UNITED STATES OF AMERICA * * , FOUNDED 1836 WASHINGTON, D. C. Bl9 574 AM1IH. (BlILLIinrDlll INDEX-CATALOGUE OF THE LIBRARY OF THE SURGEON GENERAL'S OFFICE UNITED STATES ARMY (ARMY MEDICAL LIBRARY) AUTHORS AND SUBJECTS FOURTH SERIES VOL. VII H-HYSTRIX UNITED STATES GOVERNMENT PRINTING OFFICE WASHINGTON : 1942 For sale by the Superintendent of Documents, Washington, D. C. Price $2.75 (cloth) Ard. 2L- 475".M4 13? Ser. 4 V. 7 1942 C. 2, LETTER OF TRANSMITTAL War Department, Army Medical Library, June 15, 1942. Major General James C. Magee, The Surgeon General, United States Army. General: I have the honor to report the completion of the Seventh Volume of the Fourth Series of the Index-Catalogue of the Library of the Surgeon General's Office, the fifty-fourth volume of the entire series. The volume contains references to medical subjects classified under headings from Habana to Hystrix, and the books of authors whose names begin with H. In addition to the regular text of the Catalogue, this volume also contains a few pages of continuation of the list of abbreviations used in the references. Owing to conditions in the Library which have resulted from the war, and the temporary re- moval of much of the older medical literature from the stacks, the printing of the Second Fasciculus of the Bio-Bibliography of Sixteenth Century Medical Authors prepared by Dr. Claudius F. Mayer had to be postponed until the publication of the next volume of the Index-Catalogue. Additional data on international and national congresses have been collected throughout the year, and they will be also published in the eighth volume of this Catalogue. The Seventh Volume consists of 985 pages. The following table shows the num- ber of titles in the Index-Catalogue, as far as published: Author titles Subject titles Books Journal articles First Series (16 volumes) 1880-85___ Second Series (f:l volumes') 1896-1916 Third Series (10 volumes) 1918-32... Fourth Series, 1936: Volume One________________ Volume Two________________ Volume Three_______________ Volume Four_______________ Volume Five________________ Volume Six__________________ Volume Seven_______________ Total to date_______________ 176, 364 169,812 88,876 2,779 8,892 4,281 3,798 5,499 5,836 6,443 472,580 108, 537 136,405 57,034 4,454 3,631 4,302 4,375 5,630 3,125 6,542 394,035 511,112 645, 557 603, 600 71,168 79,874 77, 479 55,950 88, 048 58,871 60,502 2,646,196 The Library now contains 424,264 volumes and 624,753 pamphlets of all sorts, including letters, broadsides and medical theses. During the last fiscal year 7,007 works have been purchased or received as gifts, including the remainder of the collec- tion of Arabic manuscripts mentioned in Volume 6, Fourth Series (60 new additions), which makes the total number of Arabic manuscripts 123, representing more than 150 authors. The Library also acquired a large number of portraits and medical illustrations. The collection of medical journals has been enlarged by 29 new sub- scriptions. The .bibliographical reference library acquired more than 50 important and out-of-print works. m tV LETTER OF TRANSMITTAL Among the old books and pamphlets recently purchased there are several early American publications, dissertations and serials. The Monthly Journal of Foreign Medicine (v. 1-2, Phila., 1828-29) and the Transactions of the Western Literary Institute (v.4 & 6, Cincinnati, 1834 & 1836) should be mentioned especially. The Library has expanded its Photoduplication and Microfilm Section to a considerable degree and is using these new facilities both for its own research projects and for the extension of its services to the other branches of the Government, to the branches of the Armed Forces of the Nation, and to other medical libraries. Very respectfully, Harold W. Jones, Colonel, Medical Corps, United States Army, The Librarian, Army Medical Library. FIFTH ADDITION TO THE LIST OF ABBREVIATIONS FOR SERIAL PUBLICATIONS Published in the Second Volume, Fourth Series, of the Index-Catalogue For explanations, see List of Abbreviations, 4. ser., v. 2 A. A. A. S. Bull., Lancaster Abstr. Papers Far East. Ass. Trop. M. Acta med. nagasaki. Acta paediat. jap. Actas Asambl. reg. med. farm. Filipinas Actas Ciba, Rio Actas Congr. amer. urol. Actas Congr. espaii. obst. gin. pediat. Actas Congr. internac. bibliot. Actas Jornad. neuropsiquiatr. panamer. Aeronaut. Engin. Rev. Admin. Papers Internat. Management Congr. Agr. Papers Internat. Management Congr. America clin. Am. M. Ass. News Am. Optic. Vision An. Acad. biol. Univ. cat 61. Chile An. Acad, brasil. cienc. An. assist, psicopat., Rio An. brasil. gin. Ann. Am. Acad. Polit. Social Sc. Ann. electrob., Lille Ann. Inst. path. bact. Bucarest Annual Rep. Commonwealth Fund, N. Y. Annual Rep. Dep. Health Ontario Annual Rep. New York Coll. Agr. An. paul. med. cir. 1. A. A. A. S. Bulletin; published monthly by the Ameri- can Association for the Advancement of Science. Lancaster, Pa., v.l, 1942- 2. Abstracts of papers and programme of the scientific sessions of the Far Eastern Association of Tropical Medicine. Calcutta, 7. Congr., 1927. 3. Acta medica nagasakiensia. Nagasaki, v.l, 1939. 4. Acta paediatrica japonica (Zika zassi) Tokyo, v.43-45, 1927-29. 5. Actas, memorias y comunicaciones de la Asamblea regional de medicos y farmac6uticos de Filipinas. Manila, 1.-3. Congr., 1912-17. 6. Actas Ciba. Rio de Janeiro, v.7, 1940- 7. Actas y trabajos; Congreso americano de urologfa. B. Aires, 2. Congr. (1937) 1939. 8. Actas del Congreso espanol de obstetricia, ginecologia y pediatrfa. Madrid, 2. Congr. (1911) 1912. 9. Actas y trabajos; Congreso internacional de bibliotecas y bibliografia. Madr., 2. Congr. (Madrid & Barcelona) 1936. 10. Actas y temas; Jornadas neuropsiquiatricas panameri- canas. Lima, 2. Reuni6n (1939) 1940. 11. Aeronautical engineering review; successor to the Aeronautical review section and edition of the Journal of the aeronautical sciences. Easton, Pa., v.l, 1942- 12. Administration papers of the International Manage- ment Congress. Baltimore, 7. Congr., 1938. 13. Agriculture papers of the International Management Congress. Baltimore, 7. Congr., 1938. 14. America clfnica; revista inter-americana de selecciones de medicina, cirugia y especialidades. N. Y., v.l, 1940- 15. American Medical Association news. Chicago (May 7) 1942- 16. American optical vision [New York] v.25, No. 4, 1941- 17. Anales de la Academia de biologfa (Universidad cat61ica de Chile; Facultad de medicina) Santiago, v.3, 1940- 18. Anais da Academia brasileira de ciencias. Rio de Janeiro, v.l, No. 3, 1941- Continuation of Ann. Acad, brasil. sc. 19. Anais da assistencia a psicopatas. Rio (1931) 1932- 20. Anais bfasileiros de ginecologia. Rio de Janeiro, v.13, 1942- 21. Annals of the American Academy of political and social science. Phila. [v.217] 1941. 22. Annales d'electrobiologie et de radiologie. Lille, v.8-12, 1905-9. 23. Annales de l'Institut de pathologie et de bactenologie de Bucarest. Bucur., v.l (1888/89) 1889; v.4-6, 1898. 24. Annual report; Commonwealth fund. N. Y., 22 (1939/40) 1941- 25. Annual report of the Department of Health of On- tario, Canad. Toronto, 16. (1940) 1941- 26. Annual report of the New York State College of Agri- culture. Ithaca, 54., 1941- 27. Anais paulistas de medicina e cirurgia. Sao Paulo, v.42, No. 1, 1941- Continuation of Annaes paulistas de medicina e cirurgia. [1] [2] An. Soc. pcru. hist. med. Anuario mod. social Cuba An. I'niv. Santo Domingo Anthrop. Briefs, N. Y. Arch, venezol. puericult. Army Vet. Bull. Arq. Assist, psicopat. S. Paulo Arq. brasil. hig. ment. Arq. brasil. med. nav. Arq. polic. civ. S. Paulo Atti Accad. med. lombarda Atti Congr. naz. microb. Atti Soc. ital. derm. sif. Avtoref. Sezd fiziol. biokhim. farm. Bausch & Lomb Mag. Beitr. Haut. &c. Fellk. Bell Teleph. Mag. Ber. Deut. Tag. psych. Hyg. Bonn Bibl. med. autor. cuban. Bibliogr. ortop., Bologna Bicent. Conf. Univ. Pennsylvania Biol. Sympos., Lane. Bol. As. med. nac, Panama Bol. clase, Lima Bol. Col. med. Habana Bol. Com. nac. peru. coop, intelect. Bol. Dep. hig. Prov. Cordoba Bol. Mun. La Plata Brooklyn Hosp. J. Bull. Alumnae Ass. Child. Hosp. School Nurs., Bost. Bull. Am. Ass. M. Rec. Librarians Bull. Colorado Bd Health Bull. Genitoinf. Dis. Bull. New England M. Center Bull. Vancouver M. Ass. Cancer Res. Capital's Health Cath. Encycl., N. Y. Chem. Leaflet Chihuahua quir. 28. Anales de la Sociedad peruana de historia de la medicina. Lima, v.l, 1939- 29. Anuario medico-social de Cuba. Habana, v.l-A 1937-38. _ 30. Anales de la Universidad de Santo Domingo. Iru- jillo, v.5, 1941- 31. Anthropological briefs. New York, No. 1, 1942- 32 Archivos venezolanos de puericultura y pediatrla. Caracas, v.3, No. 7, 1941- 33. Army veterinary bulletin; published at the Medical Field Service School as a supplement to the Army Medical Bulletin. Carlisle Barracks, Pa., v.36, 1942- 34. Sao Paulo, Brazil. Assistencia a Psicopatas. Arquivos. Sao Paulo, v.6, 1941- 35. Arquivos brasileiros de higiene mental. Rio de Janeiro, v. 13, 1942- 36. Arquivos brasileiros de medicina naval. Rio, v.2, 1941- 37. Arquivos da Polfcia civil. Sao Paulo, v.2, 1941- 38. Atti dell'Accademia medica lombarda. Milano, v.24, Nos 3-4, 1935. 39. Atti; Congresso nazionale di microbiologia. Milano, 4. Congr., 1932. 40. Atti della Societa italiana di dermatologia e sifilo- grafia e delle Sezioni interprovinciali. Bologna, v.2, fasc. 4, 1939/40- 41. Avtoreferati i tezisy; Kavkazsky sezd fiziologov, biokhimikov i farmakologov v Krasnodare. Rostov, 7. Congr., 1937. 42. Bausch (The) & Lomb magazine. Rochester, v. 18, 1942- 43. Beitrage zur Haut-, Haar und Fellkunde. Lpz., v.2, 1938- 44. Bell telephone magazine. New York, v.20, No. 2, 1941- Continuation of Bell telephone quarterly. 45. Bericht tiber die Deutsche Tagung fur psychische Hygiene in Bonn. Berl., 2. Congr., 1932. 46. Biblioteca medica de autores cubanos. Habana, v.l, 1941- 47. Bibliografia ortopedica. Bologna, v.15-21, 1932-38. 48. [Bicentennial conference] University of Pennsylvania. Philadelphia, M-2, M-5-9, M-ll-15, M-17, M-B, 1941. 49. Biological symposia. Lancaster, v.l, 1940- 50. Boletin de la Asociaci6n m6dica nacional. Panamd, v.3, No. 1, 1941- 51. Boletin del clase. Lima, v.10, 1942- 52. Boletin del Colegio medico. Habana, v.5, 1942- 53. Boletin de la Comisi6n nacional peruana de coopera- ci6n intelectual. Lima, v.l, 1941- 54. Boletin del Departamento de higiene de la Provincia de C6rdoba. C6rdoba, v.l, No. 2, 1941/42- 55. Boletin de la Municipalidad de La Plata. La Plata, v.31, No. 287, 1940- 56. Brooklyn hospital journal. Baltimore, v.l, 1939- 57. Bulletin; Alumnae Association, Children's Hospital, School of Nursing. Bost., v.21, 1941- 58. [Bulletin] American Association of Medical Record Librarians. Chicago, v.13, 1941- 59. [Bulletin] Colorado State Board of health. Denver. Colo., v.5, No. 3, 1941- 60. Bulletin of genitoinf ectious diseases. Boston, v.4, 1941- 61. Bulletin of the New England Medical Center. Boston, v.4, 1942- 62. [Bulletin] Vancouver Medical Association. Van- couver, B. C, v.18, No. 4, 1942- 63. Cancer research. Philadelphia, v.l, No. 1, 1941- 64. Capital's health. Wash., v.l, 1941- 65. Catholic (The) encyclopedia. Special ed. N. Y., 16v. 1913-14. 66. Chemistry (The) leaflet; including The science leaflet. State College, Pa., v.15, No. 1, 1941- Formerly Science (The) leaflet. 67. Chihuahua quirtirgico; revista bi-mensual. Chihua- hua, M6x., No. 27, 1942- [3] Children's Hosp. Arrow, Wash. Clin. Abstr., N. Y. Clin. Bull., Clevel. Clin. Bull. School M. Western Reserve Univ. Clin. Osteopath. Collect. Lect. Metrop. State Hosp., Waltham Collect. Papers N. York State Psychiat. Inst. Commun. Congr. derm. syph. fr. Conf. Health Welf. Merchant Seamen Conf. Union internat. tuberc. Congr. argent, urbanismo Congr. hisp. portug. cirug. Congr. internat. auxil. med. Congr. internat. med. scol. Congr. internat. popul. Congr. internat. sport Consult, internac, San Jose Contact, Pensacola Contr. Dudley Herbar. C. rend. Com. internat. eclair. C. rend. Congr. internat. enf. C. rend. Congr. internat. hydr. clim. C. rend. Congr. internat. lith. biliaire C. rend. Congr. internat. med. educ. phys. Current Biogr., N. Y. Current List M. Liter. Deliber. Congr. derm, internat. Detroit Dent. Bull. Digest Proc. Conf. Interamer. Relat. Pub. Libr. Dis. Eye &c. Throat Distrib. Papers Internat. Management Congr. Ethische Kultur 68. Children's (The) Hospital arrow. Wash., D. C, v.47, 1941- 69. Clinical abstracts. New York, v.3, 1941- 70. Clinical (The)' bulletin of the School of Medicine of Western Reserve University and its Associated Hos- pitals. Clevel., v.3, No. 3, 1939- Continuation of Clinical bulletin, Cleveland. 71. Clinical bulletin of the School of Medicine of the Western Reserve University. Cleveland, Ohio, v.5, No. 3, 1941; v.6, No. 2, 1942- 72. Clinical osteopathy. Los Angeles, v.37, No. 9, 1941- 73. Collected lectures of the 6. Seminar in neurology and psychiatry. Waltham, 1941. 74. Collected papers from the New York State Psychiatric Institute and Hospital. New York, v. 10 (1939-40) 1941 - 75. Communications; Congres des dermatologistes et syphilographes de langue francaise. Brux., v.1-2, 3. Congr., 1926. 76. Conference on the health and welfare of merchant seamen. Par., 2. Conf. (Geneva) [1929] 77. Conference de l'Union internationale contre la tuber- culose. Lausanne, 4. Conf. (1924) 1925. 78. Congreso argentino de urbanismo. B. Air., 1. Congr., 1936/38. 79. Congreso hispano-portugues de cirugia y sus especiali- dades naturales. Madrid, 1. Congr., 1898. 80. Congres international des auxiliaires medicaux, et ler Congres international de massage. Paris, 1. Congr., 1937. 81. [Rapports] Congres international de m^decine sco- laire et d'education physique. Par., l.(?) Congr. [1937] 82. Congres international de la population. Paris, 1. Congr. (1937) 1938. 83. Congres international de sport et d'education physique. Auxerre, Congr. (Bruxelles) 1905. 84. Consultorio internacional; revista centroamericana de medicina, higiene y sociologia. San Jose, Costa Rica, v.ll, 1937. 85. Contact; a news letter published quarterly by the Naval School of Aviation Medicine, Naval Air Station, Pensacola, Fla., v.l, No. 3, 1942- 86. Contributions from the Dudley Herbarium. Stanford Univ., v.3, 1941- 87. [Compte rendu des seances] Commission interna- tionale de l'eclairage. Cambr., 9. Sess. (1935) 1937. 88. Compte rendu; Congres international de l'enfance. Paris, l.(?) Congr. (1931) 1933. 89. Compte rendu; Congres international d'hydrologie et de climatologie. Paris, 1. Congr. (1886) 1887; 2. Congr. (1889) 1890; 4. Congr. (1896) 1897; 5. Congr., 1898; 6. Congr. (1902) 1903; 7. Congr. (1905) 1906. 90. Comptes rendus, discussions et communications diverses; Congres international de la lithiase biliaire. Paris, v.2, 1932. 91. Compte rendu; Congres international de mldecine appliquee a l'6ducation physique et aux sports. Lyon, 2. Congr. (Chamonix & Mont Blanc, 1934) 1936. 92. Current biography; who's news and why. New York [v.l] 1940. 93. Current list of medical literature. Washington, v.l, No. 1, 1941- 94. Deliberationes Congressus dermatologorum interna- tionalis. Budap., 9. Congr., v.1-4 (1935) 1935-37. 95. Detroit (The) dental bulletin. Detroit, v.9, No. 12, 1941- 96. Digest of proceedings and addresses; Conference on inter-American relations in the field of publications and libraries. Wash., 1940. 97. Diseases of the eye, ear, nose and throat. Chicago, v.l, No. 1, 1941- 98. Distribution papers of the International Management Congress. Baltimore, 7. Congr., 1938. 99. Ethische Kultur; Wochenschrift zur Verbreitung ethischer Bestrebungen. Berlin, v.l, 1893. [4] Eugenesia, M£x. Far East. Sc. Bull., Wash. Florida Health Notes Food Facts, Los Ang. (iac. prop, indust., Mex. (Jen. Papers Internat. Management Congr. Guanajuato med. Handel. Internat. congr. verlosk. Handel. Ned. Congr. openb. gezondh. Hartford Health Bull. Harvard Alumni Bull. Harvey Lect., Bait. Hawaii M. J. Health Off. News Digest Home Papers Internat. Management Congr. Internat. Congr. Campaign Cancer Izv. Donsk gosud. univ., Rostov J. Aeronaut. Sc. J. Christ. M. Ass. India J. Drugless Physicians J. Entom. Soc. S. Africa J. M. Soc. Co. New York J. Russ. fiz. khim. obschch., khim. ch. Karlsbad, arztl. Vortr. Liber mem. Internat. Congr. Hist. M. Libro de actas Congr. espan. otorinolar. Libro de actas Congr. nac. san., Madr. Los Angeles M. J. Med. Bull. (Standard Oil Co.) N. Y. Medicina, Madr. Medicina, Paraiba Mem. Congr. med. (Brazil) Mem. Congr. venezol. leche Mem. Conv. med. mil. mex. Mem. Inst, tisiol., Montev. Ment. Hyg. Bull., Indianap. Mil. Rev., Fort Leavenw., Mexico, v.2, No. 25, Washington, v.l, v.l, No. 7, 100. Eugenesia; revista mensual. 1941; v.3, No. 28, 1942. 101. Far Eastern science bulletin. 1941- 102. Florida health notes. Jacksonville, 1893- 103. Food facts; a magazine devoted to health through food. Los Angeles, v.3, 1927- Formerly: Western dietitian (v.1-2, 1926-27) 104. Gaceta de la propiedad industrial. Mexico, v. 13, No. 1, 1941- 105. General management papers of the International Management Congress. Baltimore, 7. Congr., 1938. 106. Guanajuato medico. Irapuato, v.l, Nos 6-7, 1941; v.2, No. 8, 1942- 107. [Handelingen] Internationaal congres voor verlos- kunde en gynaecologie. Leiden [7.] Congr., 2v., 1938. 108. Handelingen; Nederlandsch congres voor openbare gezondheidsregeling. Zwolle ('s Gravenhage) 1936. 109. Hartford health bulletin. Hartford, v.6, No. 10, 1941- 110. Harvard alumni bulletin. Cambr., v.20, 1918- 111. Harvey (The) lectures. Baltimore (1905/6) 1906- 112. Hawaii medical journal. Honolulu, v.l, 1941- 113. Health officers news digest. N. Y., v.4, No. 10, 1941- 114. Home management papers of the International Management Congress. Baltimore, 7. Congr., 1938. 115. International congress of scientific and social cam- paign against cancer. Atlantic City, N. J., 3. Congr., 1939. 116. Izvestia [Communications] Donsk gosudarstvenny universitet. Rostov, T. 5, 1925. 117. Journal of the aeronautical sciences. New York, v.8, 1941- 118. Journal of the Christian Medical Association of India, Burma and Ceylon. Mysore City, v.16, No. 5, 1941- 119. Journal (The) of drugless physicians. New York, v.3, 1942- 120. Journal of the Entomological Society of Southern Africa. Pretoria, v.4, 1941- 121. Journal of the Medical Society of the County of New York. N. York, v.l, 1942- 122. Jurnal Russkago fiziko-khimicheskago obshchestva; khimicheskaia chast. Petrograd, v.46-50, 1914-18* v.51, Nos 1-5, 1919; v.52, Nos 1-3, 1920. 123. Karlsbader arztliche Vortrage. Jena, v.12, 1930- 124. Liber memorialis; International congress of the his- tory of medicine. Anvers, 1. Congr. (1920) 1921. 125. [Libro de actas] Congreso espanol de oto-rino-laringo- logfa. Madrid, 3. Congr., 1910. 126. Libro de actas Congreso nacional de sanidad. Ma- drid, 1. Congr., pt 1, 3-4 (1934) 1935. 127. Los Angeles medical journal. Los Ang., v.l, Nos 1. 5, 7, 9-11, 1903/4; v.2, Nos 7-12, 1905. 128. Medical (The) bulletin [issued by Standard Oil Co 1 N. Y., v.2, 1935- 129. Medicina. Madrid, v.9, No. 1, 1941- 130. Medicina; orgam oficial da Sociedade de medicina e cirurgia. Paraiba, v. 10, No. 1, 1941- 131. Memorias; Congresso medico (Brazil) S. Paulo. 1 Congr., 1936. 132. Memoria; Congreso venezolano de la leche. Caracas. 1. Congr., 1939. ' 133. Memoria; Convenci6n de medicos militares mexi- canos. Mex., 1. Conv., 1936. 134. Memorias y comunicaciones [Facultad de medicina de Montevideo Instituto de tisiologia] Montevideo, iyoy. 135. Mental (The) hygiene bulletin; a publication of the Indiana Society for Mental Hygiene. Indianapolis, v.l, 1942- 136. Military review; quarterly review of military litera- ture. Pub. by the Command and General Staff School fort Leavenworth, Kans., v.22, 1942- [5] Monogr. Soc. Res. Child Develop. MSN, Toronto Nauheim. Fortbild. Lehrg. Nerv. Child, Neurosurg. Ward Rounds News in Brief, N. Orl. News Lett. Am. Heart Ass. Nu Sigma Nu Bull. Odont. tskr. Ohio Pub. Health Opera Internat. Congr. Indust. Accid. Papers Bibliogr. Soc. America Peoria Health News Ponenc. Jornad. neuropsiquiatr. pan- amer. Prelim. Statem. White House Conf. Child. Democr. Proc. Am. Ass. M. Milk Com. Proc. Am. Congr. Obst. Gyn. Proc. Am. Diabetes Ass. Proc. Internat. Conf. Silicosis Proc. Internat. Congr. Phonet. Sc. Proc. Internat. Management Congr. Proc. Maxim Gorky Med. Genet. Res. Inst., Moskva Proc. Nat. League Nurs. Educ. Proc. Virginia Acad. Sc. Product. Papers Internat. Management Congr. Progr. in Nutrit. Progr. med., Jersey City Pub. Inst, cient. Dominico-Aleman Pub. med., S. Paulo Pub. Mision estud. pat. reg. argent. Jujuy Pub. Texas Univ., Rapp. Conf. internat. lumiere Rapp. Congr. insuff. ren. Rapp. Congr. internat. hydr. clim. Rapp. Congr. internat. lith. biliaire U27475—42----II 137. Monographs of the Society for Research in child development. Washington, v.3, No. 1, 1938- 138. M S N; monthly science news. Toronto, No. 8, 1942- 139. Nauheimer Fortbildungs-Lehrgange. Bad-Nauheim, v.9, 1932; v.11-12, 1935-36; v.13-14, 1937-38. 140. Nervous (The) child; quarterly journal of psycho- pathology, psychotherapy, mental hygiene and guidance of the child. New York, v.l, 1942- 141. Neurosurgical ward rounds; University of Rochester School of Medicine and Dentistry and the University of Buffalo Medical School. Buffalo, N. Y., v.2, No. 1, 1940- 142. News-in-Brief. New Orleans, v.6, No. 6, 1941- 143. News letter of the American Heart Association. Phila., No. 1, 1942- 144. Nu Sigma Nu Bull. [n. p.] 1941. 145. Odontologisk tidskrift. Goteborg, v.49, No. 1, 1941- 146. Ohio public health. Columbus, v.5, No. 12, 1941- 147. Opera collecta Congressus Internationalis medicorum pro artificibus calamitate afflictis aegrotisque [Opera; International congress for industrial accidents and occupational disease] Budapest, 5. Congr. (1928) 1929. 148. Papers (The) of the Bibliographical Society of America. New York, v.36, 1942- 149. Peoria health news. Peoria, 111., Dec. 1941- 150. Ponencias oficiales; Jornadas neuro-psiquidtricas panamericanas. Lima, 2. Reuni6n, 1939. 151. Preliminary statement submitted to the White House Conference on children in a democracy. Wash., 1940. 152. Proceedings of the American Association of Medical Milk Commissions and the Certified Milk Producers' Association of America. Chic, 3. Meet. (1908) 1908/9; 17.-18. Conf. (1923-24) 1925. 153. Proceedings of the American Congress on obstetrics and gynecology. Evanston, 111., 1. Congr. (Cleveland, 1939) 1941. 154. Proceedings of the American Diabetes Association. Cleveland, v.l, 1941. 155. Proceedings of the International conference on silicosis. London (1938) 1940. 156. Proceedings of the International congress of phonetic sciences. Cambr., 2. Congr., Lond. (1935) 1936. 157. Proceedings of the International Management Congress. Baltimore, 7. Congr., 1938. 158. Proceedings of the Maxim Gorky medico-genetical research institute. Moskva, v.3-4, 1935-36. 159. Proceedings of the annual convention of the National League of Nursing Education. Baltimore, 19. Rep., 1913- 160. Proceedings for the Virginia Academy of Science [at top] Virginia (The) journal of science. Lexington, 18. Meet. (1939-40) 1940. 161. Production papers of the International Management Congress. Baltimore, 7. Congr., 1938. 162. Progress in nutrition. N. Y., v.4, No. 2, 1942- 163. Progreso (El) medico; revista bimestral de medicina hispano-americana. Jersey City, v.2, 1941- 164. Publicaciones Institute cientifico Dominico-Aleman. Jena, T. 1, 1939- 165. PublicacSes medicas; mensario. Sao Paulo, v. 12, No. 10, 1941- 166. Publicaci6n; Mision de estudios de patologia regional argentina de Jujuy. B. Air., No. 40, 1939. 167. Texas, U. S. A. University. Publication. 168. [Rapports; discussions; communications] Conference internationale de la lumiere. Par., 1. Congr., Lausanne & Leysin (1928) 1929. 169. Rapports; Congres de i'insuffisance renale. Par., 2. Congr. (Evian) 1938. 170. Rapports; Congres international d'hydrologie, de climatologie [etc.] Par., 14. Congr., Toulouse, 1933. 171. [Rapports] Congres international de la lithiase biliaire; Vichy 1932. Paris, v.l, 1932. [6] Rapp. Congr. internat. med. educ. phys. Rapp. Congr. internat. psychol. Rapp. Congr. san. pub., Marseille Rapp. gen. ( ongr. internat. gymn. scol. Rass. stor. Univ. Modena Rec. U. S. Nat. Conf. Social Secur. Relat. Conf. san. nac, Caracas Relat. Congr. argent, cir. Rep. AH Bengal Kala Azar Conf. Rep. Congr. Internat. Soc. Urol. Rep. Health Com. Melbourne Rep. Internat. Conf. Genet. Rev. argent, anest. Rev. brasil. biol. Rev. canad. biol. Rev. gin. obst., Rio Rev. Inst. bact. Malbran, B. Air. Rev. Liga puertorriq. cancer Rev. med. Hosp. gen. Puebla Rev. med. mun., Rio Rev. med. Parana Rev. mex. estud. antrop. Rev. obst. gin., Caracas Rev. Univ. Guayaquil R. N., Rutherford Roy. Berkshire Hosp. Rep. Safety Bull. Salub. asist. social, Habana Sao -Paulo med. Sborn. Vsesoiuz. sezd fiziol. Schr. Akad. arztl. Fortbild. Dresden Ses. Congr. med. int., B. Air., Sess. Off. internat. docum. med. mil. Sitzber. Kongr. Liga homeop. internat. Social Sc Song after Sorrow, N. Y. Stanford M. Alumni Bull. 172. Rapports; Congres international de modecine appli- quee a Induration physique et aux sports. Bar-sur- Aube, 3. Congr. (Paris) 1937. 173. Rapports et comptes rendus; International congress of psychology. Par., 11. Congr. (1937) 1938. 174. Rapports; Congres de la sant6 publique. Marseille, 3. Congr., 1922. 175. Rapport general; Congres international de gymnasti- que scolaire. Brux. [3.] Congr., 1910. 176. Rassegna per la storia della Universita di Modena e della cultura superiore modenese. Modena, Fasc. 1-2, 1929-30. 177. Record of the [United States] National Conference on Social Security. New York, 10. Conf., 1937. 178. [Relatos oficiales] Conferencia sanitaria nacional. Caracas, 2. Reun. (1931) 1932. 179. Relatos oficiales; Congreso argentina de cirugfa. B. Aires, 11. Congr. (1939) 1940. 180. Report; All-Bengal Kala-Azar conference. Calcutta, 2. Conf., 1925. 181. Report of the Congress of the International Society of Urology. New York, 7. Congr., 1939. 182. Report of the Health Committee of the City of Melbourne. Melbourne (1940) 1941. 183. Report of the International conference on genetics [etc] Lond., 3. Congr. (1906) [1907] 184. Revista argentina de anestesia y analgesia. B. Aires, v.3, No. 1, 1941- 185. Revista brasileira de biologia. Rio de Janeiro, v.l, No. 1, 1941- 186. Revue canadienne de biologie. Montr6al, v.l, 1942. 187. Revista de ginecologia e d'obstetricia. Rio de Janeiro, v.35, No. 6, 1941- Continuation of Rev. gyn. obst., Rio 188. Revista del Institute bacterio!6gico Dr Carlos G. Malbran. B. Aires, v. 10, No. 2, 1941- 189. Revista de la Liga puertorriquefia contra el cancer. Santurce, v.l, 1941- 190. Revista medica del Hospital General de Puebla; Puebla, Mex., Afio 3, 1942- 191. Revista medica municipal. Rio de Janeiro, v.l, No. 1, 1941- 192. Revista m6dica do Parand. Curitiba, v.9, No. 1, 1940- 193. Revista mexicana de estudios antropol6gicos. Me- xico, v.5, 1941- 194. Revista de obstetricia y ginecologia. Caracas, v.l, No. 1, 1941- 195. Revista de la Universidad de Guayaquil. Guaya- quil, v.ll, No. 3, 1940- 196. R. N.; a journal for nurses. Rutherford, N. J., Jan., 1941- 197. Royal Berkshire Hospital reports. Reading, Eng., 198. Safety bulletin. Washington, v.l, 1936- 199. Salubridad y asistencia social; boletin oficial. Ha- bana, v.44, No. 1, 1941- 200. Sao Paulo medico. S. Paulo, v.14, pt 1, 1941- 201. [Sbornik] Vsesoiuznyi sezd fiziologov, biokhimikov i farmakologov. Tiflis, 6. Congr., 1937. 202. Schriftenreihe; Akademie fur arztliche Fortbild une Dresden, v.l, 1939- 203. Sesiones; Congreso de medicina interna. B. Aires 1. Congr. (1936) 1937. 204. Session; Office international de documentation de m6decine militaire (Bucarest) Liege, 7. Sess. (1937) 205. [Sitzungsberichte] Kongress der Liga homeopathica internationalis. Dresden, 10. Congr., 1935 206. Social science. Menasha, Wis., v. 16, No. 2, 1941- 207. Song after sorrow; quarterly of the American Mission to Lepers. I\. York, v.4, No. 1, 1942- 208. Stanford medical alumni bulletin. Berkeley, Calif., [7] Stud. Mem. Found. Neuroendocr. Res., Worcester Tr. Ass. Life Insur. M. Dir. America Tr. Bose Res. Inst. Calcutta Tr. California Dent. Ass. Tr. Congr. argent, med. gremial Tr. Congr. lat. amer. crim. Trends M. Pract. & Res. Tribuna med., Habana Tr. Nat. Ass. Epilepsy Tr. New England Br. Am. Urol. Ass. Tr. Novosibir. gosud. inst. usoversh. vrach. Tr. Perm. med. inst. Tr. Saratov, gosud. med. inst. Tr. Stalingrad, gosud. med. inst. Univ. Iowa Doct. Diss. Vortr. Konf. Rauschgiftbekampf. Week. Epidem. Rec. (League of Nat.) West. Dietitian, Los Ang. Yearb. Duke Endowm. Yearb. U. S. Nat. Probat. Ass. 209. Studies from the Memorial foundation for neuro- endocrine research. Worcester, v. 1-3, 1927-40. 210. Transactions of the Association of Life Insurance Medical Directors of America. N. Y., v.28 (1941) 1942- Continuation of Abstracts of the proceedings ... 211. Transactions of the Bose Research Institute, Cal- cutta. Lond., v.8-10, 1932-35. 212. Transactions of the California State Dental Associa- tion. S. Franc, v.34, 1907- 213. Trabajos, Congreso argentino de medicina gremial y social. Rosario, 2. Congr. (1936) 1937. 214. Trabajos; Congreso latino-americano de criminologfa. B. Aires, T. 3, 1941. 215. Trends in medical practice and research; the bulletin of the Minnesota Medical Foundation. Minneapolis, v.l, 1939- Title of v.2, 1940. Bull. Minnesota M. Found. 216. Tribuna (La) medica. Habana, v.14, No. 263, 1941- 217. Transactions of the National Association for the Study of Epilepsy and the Care and Treatment of Epileptics. Mt Morris, N. Y., 1.-10. Meet., 1901-11. 218. Transactions of the New England Branch of the American Urological Association. Boston, 1939- 219. Trudi; Novosibirsky gosudarstvenny institut dlya usovershenstvovania. Novosibirsk, v.6, 1936. 220. Trudy i materialy Permskogo Gosudarstvennogo meditsinskogo instituta [Transactions and contributions of the Perm State medical institute] Perm, 1933; No. 6, 1935. 221. Trudi; Saratovsky gosudarstvenny medicinsky insti- tut. Saratov, T. 2, Pt 1, 1938. 222. Trudy Stalingradskogo gosudarstvennogo medi- tsinskogo instituta. Stalingrad, 1939. 223. University of Iowa doctoral dissertations, abstracts, and references. Iowa City, v.l, 1940- 224. [Vortrage] Konferenz fur Rauschgiftbekampfung. Berlin, 3. Konf., 1939. 225. Weekly epidemiological record. Geneve, No. 14, 1926- 226. Western dietitian; a modern journal of dietetics and nutrition. Los Angeles, v. 1-2, 1926-27. Title changes to: Food facts, with v.3, No. 1, May, 1927. 227. [Yearbook] Duke (The) Endowment; including annual reports of the hospital and orphan sections. Charlotte, N. C, No. 9, 1941- 228. Yearbook [United States] National Probation Associ- ation. New York, 1940- FIFTH ADDITION TO THE INDEX TO ABBREVIATIONS OF PUBLICATIONS OF CORPORATE BODIES [America] Association of Life Insurance Medical Directors of America. 210. [America] Bibliographical Society of America. 14S. [America] Certified Milk Producers' Association of America. 152. American Academy of Political and Social science. 21. American Association of Medical Milk Commis- sions. 152. American Association of Medical Record Librar- ians. .">*. [American] Congreso americano de urologfa. 7. American Congress on obstetrics and gynecology. 153. American Diabetes Association. 154. American Heart Association. 143. American Medical Association. 15. American I'rological Association. New England Branch. 218. [Argentina] Congreso argentino de cirugia. 179. [Argentina] Congreso argentino de medicina gremial y social. 213. [Argentina] Congreso argentino de urbanismo. 78. [Argentina] Congreso de medicina interna. 203. Argentina. Mision de Estudios de Patologia regional argentina de Jujuy. 166. Bengal. All-Bengal Kala-Azar conference. 180. Berkshire (Royal) Hospital. 197. Boston, Mass. Children's Hospital. School of Nursing. Alumnae Association. 57. Boston, Mass. New England Medical Center. 61. [Brasil] Academia brasileira de ciencias. IS. Brasil. Congresso medico. 131. Brooklyn Hospital. 56. Bucarest. Institut de pathologie et de bacterio- logie. 23. Buenos Aires. Institute bacteriol6gico Dr Carlos G. Malbran. 188. Calcutta. Bose Research Institute. 211. California State Dental Association. 212. Chile. Universidad catelica de Chile; Facultad de medicina. 17. Colorado. State Board of Health. 59. Conference on the health and welfare of merchant seamen. 76. C6rdoba (Province) Arg. Departamento de higiene. 54. Deutsche Tagung fur psychische Hygiene. 45. Dominican Republic. Institute cientifico Domi- nico-Aleman. 164. [Dresden] Akademie fiir arztliche Fortbildung. 202. Duke Endowment. 227. Far Eastern Association of Tropical Medicine. 2. [France] Congres des dermatologistes et syphilo- graphes de langue francaise. 75. [France] Congres de la sante publique. 174. Guayaquil, Ecuador. Uniyersidad. 195. Habana, Cuba. Colegio medico. 52. [i India. Christian Medical Association of India. 118. Internationaal congres voor verloskunde en gynaecologie. 107. [International] Commission internationale de Peclairage. 87. International Conference on Genetics. 183. International Conference on Silicosis. 155. [International] Congres de gymnastique p6da- gogique, militaire, m«5dicale et esthetique. 175. [International] Congres de l'insumsance r6nale. 169. [International] Congres international des auxi- liaires medicaux, et ler Congres international de massage. Paris. 80. [International] Congres international de l'en- fance. 88. [International] Copgres international de gym- nastique scolaire. 175. [International] Congres international d'hydro- logie et de climatologie. 89. [International] Congres international de la lithiase biliaire. Vichy. 90, 171. [International] Congres international de mede- cine appliqu6e a l'6ducation physique et aux sports. 91, 172. [International] Congres international de mede- cine scolaire et d'education physique. 81. [International] Congres international de la population. 82. [International] Congres international de sport et d'education physique. 83. [International] Congreso internacional de biblio- tecas y bibliograffa. 9. International Congress of the History of Medi- cine. 124. International Congress for Industrial Accidents and Occupational Disease. 147. International Congress for Light. 168. International Congress of Medical Hydrologie. 170. International Congress of phonetic sciences. 156. International Congress of Psychology. 173. International congress of scientific and social campaign against cancer. 115. International Dermatological Congress. 94. [International] Kongress der Liga homeopathica internationalis. 205. International Management Congress. 12, 13 98, 105, 114, 157, 161. [International] Office international de documen- tation de medecine militaire. 204. International Society of Urology. 181. [International] Union internationale contre la tuberculose. 77. Iowa. University of. 223. Italy. Congresso nazionale di microbiologia. 39. [Italy] Societa italiana de dermatologia e sifilo- grafia e delle Sezioni interprovinciali. 40. Kavkazsky sezd fiziologov, biokhimikov i farma- kologov. 41. [9] Konferenz fur Rauschgiftbekampfung. 224. La Plata. Municipalidad de. 55. [Latin-America] Congreso latino-americano de criminologia. 214. League of Nations. 225. Melbourne Health Committee. 182. Mexico. Convenci6n de medicos militares mexi- canos. 133. Milano, Italy. Accademia medica lombarda. 38. Minnesota Medical Foundation. 215. Modena. Universidad. 176. Montevideo. Instituto de tisiologia. 134. Moskva. Maxim Gorky Medico-Genetical Re- search Institute. 158. Nederlandsch congres voor openbare gezondheids- regeling. 108. [New York] Commonwealth Fund. 24. New York Academy of Medicine. Inter-America Division. 14. New York County, N. Y. Medical Society of the County of New York. 121. New York State College of Agriculture. 26. New York State Psychiatric Institute and Hospital. 74. Novosibirsk. Gosudarstvenny institut dlya usovershenstvovania. 219. Ontario, Canad. Department of Health. 25. Panama. Asociaci6n medica nacional. 50. [Panamerican] Jornadas neuro-psiquiatricas pan- americanas. 10, 150. Paraiba. Sociedade de medicina e cirurgia. 130. Pennsylvania, University of. Bicentennial Con- ference. 48. Perm State Medical Institute. 220. Peru. Comisi6n nacional peruana de cooperaci6n intelectual. 53. [Peru] Sociedad peruana de historia de la medicina. 28. Petrograd. University. Russkoe fiziko-khimi- cheskoe obshchestvo. 122. [Philippine Islands] Asamblea regional de medi- cos y farmaceuticos de Filipinas. 5. Puebla, Mex. Hospital general. 190. Puerto Rico. Liga puertorriquena contra el cancer. 189. Rostov. Donsky gosudarstvenny universitet. 116. [Russia] Sezd fiziologov, biokhimikov [etc.] 201. Santo Domingo, Dom. Universidad. 30. Sao Paulo. Assistencia a psicopatos. 34. Saratovsky gosudarstvenny medicinsky institut. 221. Society for Research in Child Development. 137. South Africa. Entomological Society of Southern Africa. 120. [Spain] Congreso espanol de obstetricia, gine- cologia y pediatria. 8. [Spain] Congreso espanol de oto-rino-laringologia. 125. [Spain] Congreso hispano-portugues de cirugia y sus especialidades naturales. 79. [Spain] Congreso nacional de sanidad. 126. Stalingrad. Stalinsgradsky gosudarstvenny meditsinsky institut. 222. Standard oil company. 128. Stanford University. Dudley Herbarium. 86. Texas University. 167. [United States] Medical Field Service School. 33. [United States] National Association for the Study of Epilepsy and the Care and Treatment of Epileptics. 217. [United States] National Conference on Social Security. 177. [United States] National League of Nursing Education. 159. [United States] National Probation Association. 228. [United States] Naval School of Aviation Medi- cine. 85. United States. State Department. 96. Vancouver Medical Association. 62. Venezuela. Conferencia sanitaria nacional. 178. Venezuela. Congreso venezolano de la leche. 132. Virginia Academy of Science. 160. Waltham, Mass. Metropolitan State Hospital. 73. Washington, D. C. Children's Hospital. 68. Western Reserve University. School of Medi- cine. 70, 71. White House Conference on Children in a Democracy. 151. Worcester. Memorial Foundation for Neuro- endocrine Research. 209. 227475—42---ill CATALOGUE H., D. P. HAAG H., D. P. Anti-tuberculosis reconstruction. 38p. pi. 12? Dubl., Maunsel & Co., 1919. HAAB, Otto, 1850-1931. K. A. Obituary. Arch. Ophth., Chic, 1932, n. ser., 7: 120—Nekrolog. Arch. Augenh., 1931-32, 105: 571.—Patry, A. [Necrologie] Ann. ocul., Par., 1932, 169: 223-5.—Vogt, A. Nekrolog. Klin. Mbl. Augenh., 1931, 87: 674-6. For portrait see Klinische Monatsblatter fur Augenheil- kunde, 1925, 75: HAACK, Elisabeth, 1908- *Ueber die Einwirkung der Erdalkalichloride auf diastatische Fermente [Munster] 16p. 8? Werne-Lippe, F. Grube, 1935. HAACK, Kate, 1909- *Beitrage zur Frage der Ablatio-Operation [Rostock] 31p. 22cm. Diisseld., G. H. Nolte, 1936. HAACK, Kurt, 1901- *Vereinheitlichung der Blutuntersuchungs-Verfahren bei Bleige- fahrdeten [Rostock] 36p. 8? Chemnitz, Schloss, 1929. HAACK, Siegfried, 1909- *Blutdruck- messungen bei Hunden und ihr Wert als klinische Untersuchungsmethode. 54p. 8? Lpz., A. Edelmann, 1933. HAACK, Wilhelm Nikolaus, 1907- *Ein Versuch die Bazillentrager bei Tuberkulose zu erfassen. 12p. 8? Wurzb., K. Roll, 1935. HAACK, Wolfgang, 1904- *Beitrag zur Kasuistik der Erythrodermia congenitalis ich- thyosiformis (Hyperkeratosis congenita diffusa benigna (Zieler) 29p. 8? Erlangen, K. Dores, 1933. HAACKE, Wilhelm, 1905- *Zur Lungen- embolie. 21p. 8? Berl. [n. pub.] 1930. HAAF, Nelly, 1910- *Ein Fall von Pseudogliom und Mikrophthalmus [Heidel- berg] 19p. 22Kcm. Walldorf, F. Lamade, 1936. HAAG, Edouard, 1891- *Les formes cliniques du surmenage chez le cheval [Alfort] 67p. 8? Par., Vigot freres, 1929. HAAG, Erhard, 1902- *Ueber den Bau der Labyrinthkapsel einiger Affenarten. p. 14-23. 8? Wurzb. [n. pub.] 1933. Also Arch. Ohr. &c. Heilk., 1933, 136: HAAG, Friedrich Erhard, 1896- *Der Milzbrandbazillus, seine Kreislaufformen und Varietaten [Wurzburg] p.271-321. 3 pi. 8! Munch., R. Oldenbourg, 1927. Also Arch. Hyg., Munch., 1927, 98: HAAG, Georg Viktor, 1910- *Carcinom der Gallenblase und aussere Gallenfistel. 15p. 8? Mtinch., J. Schreiber, 1936. HAAG, Hans, 1899- *Ueber Strangu- lationsileus des Magenausganges durch ein isoliert verlaufendes Ligamentum teres hepatis. 21p. 8? Bonn, P. Kubens, 1929. HAAG, Harvey Bernhardt, 1900- See Waddell, James Alexander, & Haag, H. B. Alcohol in moderation and excess. 184p. 8? Richmond, Va., 1938. Also 3. ed. 221p. 1940. HAAG, Hilmar, 1906- *Ergebnisse der Avertin-Narkose. 40p. 8? Munch, [n. pub.] 1932. 227475—vol. 7, 4th series- HAAG, Hubert, 1909- *Les formes an^miques de la Ieuc6mie aigue [Strasbourg] 59p. 23^cm. Metz, J. Lorrain, 1935. HAAG, Luise, 1906- *Die Bedeutung der Driisen mit innerer Sekretion, insbesondere der Schilddrtise, fiir die Pathogenese der Rachitis. 34p. 22cm. Koln, J. Borowsky, 1936. HAAGA, Johanna, 1906- *Beitrag zur Stoning des Kochsalzstoffwechsels bei universel- len Dermatosen [Mtinchen] 16p. 8? Ochsen- furt, Fritz & Rappert, 1931. HAAGEN, Arthur. *Beitrage zur Kenntnis der Entstehung und Bedeutung der paranuklearen Gebilde in den Pankreaszellen. 23p. pi. 8? Zur., J. Schabelitz, 1897. HAAGEN, Hermann, 1911- *Die eiweiss- spaltenden Fermente der Pflanze. 27p. 8? Munch., Hohenhaus, 1935. HAAGER, Berthold, 1908- *Ueber eine Tuberkulose der Lunge mit vorwiegend sub- pleuraler Ausbreitung [Miinchen] 15p. 8! Wurzb., K. Triltsch, 1933. See also Buchner, Franz, Weber, A., & Haager, B. Koro- narinfarkt und Koronarinsuffizienz. 104p. roy. 8? Lpz., 1935. HAAGLAND, Magnus, 1876-1935. Madsen, S. T. [Biography] Nord. med., 1939, 1: 427-31, portr.—Murray, J. A. Obituary. J. Path. Bact., Cambr., 1935, 41: 569-71, portr.—Thj0tta, T. [Obituary] Norsk, mag. laegevid., 1935, 96: 336-8. HAAKE, Heinz, 1908- *Ueber die Ein- wirkung von Jodsalzen auf den intermediaren Kohlenhydratstoffwechsel [Munster] 15p. 8? Werne-Lippe, F. Grube, 1934. HAAKSHORST, Erwin, 1910- *Die Takata-Reaktion und ihr Verhalten bei Leber- schadigungen [Koln] 18p. 22cm. Diisseld., G. H. Nolte, 1936. HAAN, Henri de. *Bijdrage tot de pharmacie van het opium. 4 p. 1. 68p. 8? [Amst.] de Bussy [1920] HAAR, Hildegard, 1910- *Beitrag zur therapeutischen Anwendung von Kongorot als Haemostypikumbei haemorrhagischen Diathesen im Kindesalter [Jena] 31p. 22cm. Erlangen, M. Krahl, 1936. HAARDT, Ewald, 1910- *Ueber Epididy- mitis und Funiculitis gonorrhoica [Kiel] 16p. 22cm. Wanne, P. Hornschuh, 1936. HAARER, Johanna. Die deutsche Mutter und ihr erstes Kind. 266p. illust. 8? Munch., J. F. Lehmann, 1938. HAARER, Otto Friedrich, 1899- *Ueber Ergiisse beim kunstlichen Pneumothorax [Miinchen] p.459-519. 8? Berl., J. Springer, 1932. Also Beitr. Klin. Tuberk., 1932, 81: HAARMANN, Anna Luise, 1907- *Der Eosinophilen-Versuch nach Brosamlen-Muller bei Tuberkulosen und Nicht-Tuberkulosen [Ber- lin] p.292-308. 8? Lpz., Akad. Verl. Ges., 1934. Also Fol. haemat., Lpz., 1933-34, 51: (D HAARMANN 2 HAAS HA ARM ANN. Ewald [Heinrich] 1906- *Die Knochonlagerung. 2Sp. 8? Marb., K. Euker, 1933. HAARMANN, Friedrich Wilhelm, 1900- *Das Wesen und die Bedeutung dos Dosquet- Krankensaales fiir die Behandlung der Tuber- kulose. ltip. 8? Berl., E. Ebering, 1928. HAARMANN, Fritz, 1904- *Blutunter- suchungen bei gewerblichen Schadigungen durch physikalische Einfliisse [Munster] 27p. S? Erlangen, K. Dores, 1932. HAARMANN, Walter, 1901- *Neuere Tlieoricn iiber den Mechanismus und Verlauf der biologischen Oxvdationsvorgange. 71p. 8? Miinch.. R. Muller & Steinicke, 1927. HAARMANN, Wilhelm, 1909- *Das spatere Schicksal der Falle von Pyelitis gravi- darum [Berlin] 27p. 21cm. Hagen, P. Potz, 1937. HAAS, Carl. *Ueber periphere und Plexus- Neuritiden durch Zerrung und Ueberdehnung [Basel] 28p. 8? Laupen [n. pub.] 1927. HAAS, Carl. 1906- *Vergleichende Unter- suchungen iiber die Volumenbestandigkeit einiger Abdruckgipsmischungen unter besonderer Be- riicksichtigung der abkochbaren [Gottingen] 20p. 8? Berl., H. Pusch, 1931. HAAS, Clara, 1903- *Zur Frage des isolierten Pemphigus der Mundschleimhaut. 17p. 8? Miinst., H. Buschmann, 1935. HAAS, Emile. Optiquc th6orique et appliquee. p.301-90. 25cm. Par., Masson & cie, 1939. In Traite opht., T. 2 HAAS, Erich, 1907- *Ueber Graviditiit im rudimentaren Nebenhorn eines Uterus bicornis unicollis. 36p. 8? Heidelb., Bechstein, 1931. HAAS, Ernst, 1910- *Pernocton in der Eklampsiebehandlung [Freiburg] 19p. 21}£cm. Coburg, Tageblatt-Haus., 1935. HAAS, Ernst Albert. *Studien iiber die historische Entwicklung von Tierzucht und Tierheilkunde und ihre Correlation [Bern] 68p. 8? Offenburg, H. Zuschneid, 1912. HAAS, Erwin, 1903- *Untersuchungen iiber objektive und subjektive Ermiidung bei willkiirlichen Kontraktionen. p.386-94. 8? Bresl. [n. pub.] 1929. Also Arch. ges. Physiol., 1927-28, 218: HAAS, Etelka, 1904- *Ueber die Chro- moptom^trie Imberts als Methode der Refrak- tionsbestimmung; mit Untersuchungen iiber die Chromasie des Auges. p.528-35. 8? Lpz. [n. pub.] 1931. Also Arch. Ophth., Berl., 1931, 126: HAAS [Franz Beno Wilhelm] Richard, 1910- *Experimentelle Untersuchungen am auto- matischen harmonischen Analysator nach Garten. 25p. 8? Lpz., Frommhold & Wendler, 1935. HAAS, Friederike, 1912- *Hamophilie im Nicht-Inzuchtsgebiet; eine genealogische und erbbiologische Studie [Miinchen] 55p. 21cm. Speyer, Pilger, 1938. HAAS, Georg, 1886- Die Methodik der Blutauswaschung (Dialysis in vivo) p.717-54. 8? [Berl., 1935] In Handb.biol. Arbeitsmeth. (Abderhalden, E.) 1935. Abt. V. Teil 8. HAAS, Gudrun, 1904- *Ueber Sterilisie- rungs-Operationen; ein Bericht aus der Universi- t;itsfrauenklinik Tubingen iiber die Jahre 1918-30 [Tubingen] 48p. 8? Boblingen, R. Schlecht, 1936. HAAS, Guido. *Die Allergosen in der Zahn- heilkunde [Basel] 50p. 8? Zur., Buchdr. Berichthaus, 1936. HAAS, Gustave W. Health through sunshine and diet. 176p. S? Los Aug., Calif., Gem Pub. Co. [1926] HAAS, Hans, 1905- *Die Bedeutung der Blutuntersuchung fiir die Diagnose und Prognose der Kehlkopftuberkulose. 35p. 8? Giessen [n. pub.] 1931. HAAS, Hans, 1906- *Kritische Unter- suchungen iiber die Ektoskopie. p.415-31. 8? Berl. [n. pub.] 1933. Also Deut. Arch. klin. M., 1933, 174: HAAS, Hans, 1906- *Ueber Veriinde- rungen am Zement nach chronischen Wurzel- hautentziindungen und deren Folgezustiinde [Wurzburg] 26p. 8? Bottrop, W. Postberg, 1933. HAAS, Hans, 1907- *Beitrag zur Kennt- nis der anatomischen Grundlagen der juvenilen Paralyse [Munster] 39p. 8? Bottrop, W. Postberg, 1932. HAAS, Hans, 1909- *Die Rontgen- strahlenbehandlung der Magen- und Duodenal- geschwiire und deren Erfolge [Freiburg] 24p. 21cm. Bleicherode, C. Nieft, 1937. HAAS, Harry Forest, 1890- How to psy- choanalyze the Bible. 5 p. 1. 116p. illust. 20Hcm. Orangeburg, S. C, Haas publication committee [1939] HAAS, Heinz, 1912- *Weisse Flecke im Schmelz vom klinischen Standpunkt betrachtet. 20p. 8? Erlangen, K. Dores, 1937. HAAS, Hildegard, 1906- *Zahnarztliche Untersuchungen iiber den Zustand des Gebisses und der Mundhohle bei Hebammen. 37p. 8°. Bonn, P. Kubens, 1929. HAAS, Hugo, 1901- *Wandlungen im Symptomenbilde der epidemischen Encephalitis. 30p. 8? Bonn, H. Trapp, 1930. HAAS, Irvin. A bibliography of material relating to private presses, xvi, 57p. 8? Chic, Black Cat Press, 1937. HAAS, J. H. de, & MEULEMANS, I. O. Melk in het bijzonder als zuigelingenvoedsel. 4 p. 1. 104p. inch tab. 24J^cm. Batavia, Druk. Smits [1940] HAAS, Josef. *Die Endangitis tuberculosa aortae [Basel] p.315-24. 8? Berl., J. Springer, 1931. Also Beitr. Klin. Tuberk., 78: HAAS, Karl, 1911- *Ueber die Moglich- keit einer Erkennung und differentialdiagnosti- schen Abgrenzung der tertiaren Lungensyphilis des Erwachsenen [Bonn] 44p. 22V>cm. Briihl, K. Martini, 1937. HAAS, Manfred, 1885- *Ueber eine praktisch wichtige Varietat am menschlichen Becken. 12p. 8? Wurzb., C. J. Becker, 1928. HAAS, Maria, 1910- *Die Krebssterb- lichkeit im Amtsbezirk Offenburg in der Zeit von 1921 bis 1932, eine lokalstatistische Unter- suchung. 75p. 8? Freib. i. B., K. Henn, 1933. HAAS, Max, 1901- *Beitrage zur Be- handlung der Psoriasis vulgaris. 40p 8° Erlangen, K. Dores, 1930. HAAS, Max, 1910- *Untersuchungen an kiinstlich rachitisch gemachten Ratten nach Injektion von Hamate- und Koproporphvrin 19p. 8? Miinch., C. Wolf & Sohn, 1936 HAAS, Maximilian, 1907- *Knochenan- bau unter der Einwirkung von Kurzwellen 16p 21cm. Weende, F. Pieper, 1937. HAAS, Otto, 1905- *Xeroderma pig- mentosum und die rontgengeschadigte Haut. Vergleichende Studien an Hand von zwei Fallen HAAS 3 HAASE [Miinchen] 34p. 8? Dillingen a. D. [n. pub.] 1930. HAAS, Otto Robert. *Wiederbelegung durch Transfusion arterialisierten Blutes in die Carotis communis. 16p. 8? Basel, Philograph. Verl., 1935. HAAS, Raymond Michel, 1912- *Les psychoses puerperales; signes, pronostic et traite- ment. 79p. 24cm. Par., M. Lavergne, 1939. HAAS, Reinhold, 1900- *Histologische Untersuchungen iiber die Wirkung des Tiranal [Tubingen] 32p. 4 pi. 8? Zeulenroda, B. Sporn [1934] HAAS, Richard Court Simon, 1910- *La langue lisse et sa valeur diagnostique [Paris] 51p. 24cm. Mulhouse, P. R. Weber & fils, 1939. HAAS, Theodor, 1908- *Besteht zwischen Ulcus molle und Scabies ein epidemiologischer Gegensatz [Miinchen] 13p. 8? Wurzb., R. Mayr, 1934. HAAS, Vfictor] H[oward] 1909- See Eskey, C. R., & Haas, V. H. Plague in the western part of the United States. 63p. 8? Wash. [n. pub.] 1940. HAAS, Walter, 1907- *Die Rolle des Kochsalzes im Organismus unter besonderer Beriicksichtigung seiner Beziehungen zum Haut- organ. 19p. 8? Giessen [n. pub.] 1930. HAAS, Walther, 1903- *Zwei Falle von ausbleibender Verrostung bei Sitz des Splitters im Augengrund; ein Fall von Rostriickbildung an der Regenbogenhaut. 14p. 8? Freib. i. B. [n. pub.] 1931. HAAS, Willi, 1908- *Kunstdiingemittel und Sekundarinfektionen. p. 198-208. 8? Giessen, J. Springer, 1938. Also Zschr. Hyg., 1937-38, 120: HAASE, Edgar, 1900- *Ueber die Ver- anderungen einiger pharmazeutischer Tinkturen und Alkaloidsalzlosungen durch die Bestrahlung mit Sonnen- und ultraviolettem Licht. 60p. ch. 8? Halle, O. Jung, 1930. HAASE, Franciscus Gerardus Maria, 1874- [Fortieth anniversary of medical practice] Ned. tschr. geneesk., 1940, 84: 2178, portr. HAASE [Friedrich Gustav] Rudolf, 1905- * Monographic iiber die Kastration des Katers. 38p. 8? Lpz., A. Edelmann, 1931. HAASE, Friedrich [Karl Moritz] 1893- *Ueber den extraperitonealen Kaiserschnitt [Halle] 47p. 8? Sangerhausen, Engelke, 1932. HAASE, Gerhard, 1908- *Statistische Untersuchungen iiber Diabetes mellitus. 23p. 8? Halle, E. Klinz, 1934. HAASE, Gertrud von, 1909- *Beitrag zur Diagnostik der Pickschen Krankheit [Mun- ster] 27p. 21cm. Lengerich, Lengerich. Han- delsdr., 1938. HAASE, Gustav, 1904- *Bestimmung der Farbtonempfindlichkeit des menschlichen Auges bei verschiedenen Helligkeiten und Satti- gungen; Bau eines empfindlichen Farbpyrometers. p.75-105. 8? Berl., Barth, 1934. HAASE, Hellmuth, 1906- *Ueber die Eigenschaften der vergiitbaren Palladium- Silber- Gold- Legierung Alba auf Grund metallographi- scher Untersuchungen. 29p. 8? Erlangen, M. Dores, 1937. HAASE, Helmut, 1908- *Ueber das Zusammenwirken von Adrenalin und Tyramin auf den Sauerstoffverbrauch iiberlebender Ge- webe [Munster] 29p. 21cm. Lengerich, Lengerich. Handelsdr., 1936. HAASE, Karl, 1910- *Untersuchungen iiber die Resorption von Ferrichlorid durch die Froschhaut [Leipzig] 24p. 23}^cm. Worms a. Rh., Gebr. Hoffmann [1936] HAASE, Paul Gerhard, 1903- *Ueber seltene Tumoren der weiblichen Harnrohre. 19p. 8? Halle, H. John, 1930. HAASE, Severin, 1899- *Bericht iiber die erste Halfte des XXV. Tausend der Geburten an der Universitats-Frauenklinik zu Wurzburg [Wurzburg] 33p. 2 tab. 8? Miinst., Althoff, 1927. HAASE, Werner. Kurze Anweisungen iiber die Fiihrung einer chirurgischen Krankenabtei- lung; fiir Schwestern und Aerzte. 112p. 21cm. Lpz., G. Thieme, 1938. HAASE-KOEPPE, Margerit, 1895- *Welche Rolle spielt der Phosphor im Phosphor- lebertran? [Giessen] 35p. 8? Stuttg., F. Enke, 1928. Also Arch. Kinderh., 1928, 85: 257-90 " HAASEN, Erich, 1911- *Ueber das Jotaplast ein neues Hilfsmittel bei der Herstellung von Immediatprothesen. 26p. 8? Bonn, A. Brand, 1936. HAASL, Henry William, 1900- *The injection treatment of varicose veins [Marquette Univ.] 21p. 4? Milwaukee, 1930. Typewritten. HAASS, Heinrich, 1891- *Die Beziehung der enterogenen Cholangie zur akuten und sub- kutanen Leberatrophie [Leipzig] 30p. 8? [Zeulenroda, A. Oberreuter] 1920. HAASTERT, Siegfried, 1903- *Eine schwere Reitverletzung mit Symphysenriss, Hiift- beinverschiebung, Harnrohrenmastdarmfistel und Aneurysma der Gesaszschlagader [Freiburg i. B.] 36p. 8? Mettmann, O. Kolp [1929] HAASZ, Antonin Dominik, 1886- Brdlik, J. [Seventieth anniversary] Cas. 16k. Cesk., 1936, 75: 909, portr. HAAXMANN, Pieter Jacob, 1810-? [Biography] In Gallerie hervorrag. Ther. Pharm. Gegenwart, Geneve, 1897, 402. HABABOU-SALA, Joseph, 1896- *Nou- velles recherches sur ie chancre mou avec vaccino- therapie locale. 80p. 8? Par., Jouve & cie, 1925. HABANA, Cuba. Academia de ciencias medicas, fisicas y naturales. Estado actual. 51p. photogr. 8? Habana, M. G6mez, 1939. HABANA, Cuba. Clinica de la Asociacion de Damas de La Covadonga. Boletin mensual. Habana, v.l, No. 6, 1934- HABANA, Cuba. Hospital Calixto Garcia. Instituto del Cancer. Boletin de la Liga contra el Cancer. Habana, v.2, 1927- HABANA, Cuba. Hospital municipal de la Habana. Archivos. Habana, v.l, 1922. HABANA, Cuba. Instituto Finlay. Mono- graffas. No. 2-7. 6v. 2634cm. Habana, O'Reilly, 1936-39. CONTENTS No. 2. El Congreso internacional de la ciencia de poblaci6n (J. F. Rodriguez Perez) 1936. 80p. No. 3. Contribuci6n al estudio del diagn6stico, progn6stica y tratamiento del barbiturismo (R. de Castro y Bachiller) 1937. 58p. No. 4. La reacci6n de hiperfijaci6n antigenica en la fiebre tifoidea (P. Domingo Sanjuan) 1937. 68p. No. 5. Aportaciones del Instituto Finlay al VII Congreso de la Asociacion medica Pan-Americana (Instituto Finlay) 1938. 196p. No. 6. Conferencias sobre malaria ofrecidas en el Instituto Finlay (M. F. Boyd) 1939. 79p. No. 7. El Instituto Finlay y la nueva epidemiologia de la fiebre amarilla (W. H. Hoffmann) 1939. 92p. ---- Salubridad y asistencia social; boletin oficial. Habana, v.44, No. 1, 1941- HABANA 4 HABER HABANA, Cuba. Sociedad de estudios clinicos. Archivos. Habana, v.27, No. 1, 1929- Missing numbers. HABANA. See also Cuba. Cosculluela, J. A. F.studio de saneamiento de la bahfa y litoral de la Habana. San. & benef., Habana, 1939, 42: 29^ 324.—Dispensario Tamayo; estadfsticas de los trabajos reali- zados durante el afio 1939. Ibid., 293.—Fernandez, F. M. Los fines de Instituto Finlay. Actas Congr. As. m£d. panamer. (1928-29) 1930, 1. Congr., 82-5.—Instituto Finlay; estadfstica de los trabajos realizados durante el afio 1939. San. & benef., Habana, 1939, 42: 289-92.—Le-Roy y Cassa, J. Notas de- mograficas f-obre la Hubana en 1918. Rev. med. cubana, 1919, 30: 6-14.—Martin, M. Informe anual sanitario y demografico del t£rmino nmnicipid de la Habana, correspondiente el afio de 1934. San. & U-m-f., Habana, 1937, 40: 161; 1938, 41: 151. HABBE, Karl [Ludwig Kurt] 1902- *Ueber zufallig in Operationswunden zuriick- gelassene Frarndkorper [Gottingen] 22p. 8? Celle, A. Pohl, 1926. HABBE, Stephen, 1903- *Personality adjustments of adolescent boys with impaired hearing [Columbia Univ.] 85p. 8? N. Y., 1936. HABBEN, Hanna, 1909- *Experimen- teller Beitrag iiber das Verhalten verschiedener Gewebe gegeniiber Implantaten von frischem beziehungsweise gegltihtem Dentin. 28p. 8! Weende, A. F. Pieper, 1934. HABBEN, Siebelt, 1905- *Die Unter- schenkelbriiche der letzten sechs Jahre (Novem- ber 1925 bis November 1931) ihre Behandlungs- methoden und ihre Ergebnisse [Kiel] 68p. 8° Koln, J. Borowskv, 1934. HABEDANK, Hans, 1908- *Beobach- tung des Milchsaurespiegels im Blut bei renaler Schiidigung. 29p. 8? Bonn, P. Kubens, 1933. HABEDANK, Siegfried, 1909- *Ein Fall von Obliteration des Ductus thoracicus mit xanthomatoser Lymphendotheliose [Leipzig] 18p. 23'Jem. Zeulenroda, A. Oberreuter, 1937. HABEKUSS [Giinther] Gottfried, 1911— *Die Infektionskrankheiten in den Kleinkinder- anstalten unter besonderer Beriicksichtigung der Leipziger Verhaltnisse [Leipzig] 22p. 23^cm. Zeulenroda, A. Oberreuter, 1937. HABEL, Mary Louise, & MILTON, Hazel Doris. The graduate nurse in the home; meeting community needs, xviii, 290p. Must. 2 pi. 21cm. Phila., J. B. Lippicott Co. [1939] HABELT, Theodor [Konrad] 1904- *Zur Geschichte der medizinischen Verwendung der Kamille (Matricaria chamomilla L.) 32p. 8? Lpz., A. Edelmann, 1935. HABENDORFF, Ernst, 1889- *Ueber primare und radikalchirurgische Versorgung der Kriegswunden. 23p. 2 1. 8? Frankf. a. M., Werner & Winter, 1918. HABENICHT, Anneliese, 1912- *Portio- stumpfcarcinom. 17p. 22}£cm. Berl., R. Pfau, 1937. HABENICHT, Gerhart [Wolfgang] 1911- *Ueber Luxationen der Handwurzelknochen in der Leipziger chirurgischen Universitatsklinik 1913-36 [Leipzig] 40p. tab. 23#cm. Zeulen- roda, A. Oberreuter, 1937. HABENICHT, Hermann, 1897-1940. [Nekrolog] Deut. Heilpflanze, 1940, 6: 133. HABENULA. See Brain; Pineal body. HABER, Fritz, 1868-1934. Laue, M. Ton. Nekrolog. Naturwissenschaften, 1934, 22: 97. For Festschrift see Biochemische Zeitschrift, 1928, 203: Also Naturwissenschaften, 1928, 16: portr. Also Zeitschrift far phyaikalische Chemie, Abt. A., 1928, 139: portr. HABER, Gustav G. INNS- Beitrag zur Geschichte der Zahnheilkunde bei den Aegyptern, Mabvloniern und Juden; eine kulturhistorische Studio. 41p. sm. 4? [Bresl., T. Schatzky, 1026] •---• Die Aufgaben der Kaudruckmessung und der Zahndruckprufung. 2 p. 1. 116p. 8? [Berl., G. G. Haber, 1926] ---- Die Zahnwurzel als Stiitzpunkt der Prothese; bildliche Darstellung von praktischen Winkeri und Tagesfragen der konservierenden, chirurgischen, technischen und odontoplastischen Zahnheilkunde, Leitfaden und Atlas. 162p. 46 pi. 8? Berl., G. G. Haber, 1926. HABER, Rudolf, 1907- *Blutgerinnungs- versuche mit der Hohlperlenkapillarmethode unter besonderer Beriicksichtigung des Tempera- tureinfiusses [Berlin] p.90-8. 8? Lpz., Akad. Verl., 1932. Also Fol. haemat., Lpz., 1932, 48: HABER, Stanislaus, 1899- *Die Bedeu- tung des Meckelschen Divertikels in der Chirur- gie [Berlin] 32p. 8? Charlottenb., Gebr. Hoff- mann, 1928. HABERDA, Albin, 1868-1933. See von Hofmann, Eduard, & Haberda, A. Lehrbuch der gerichtlichen Medizin [&c] 1234p. roy. 8? Berl., 1U27. For biography see Deut. Aerzte-Ztg, 1933, 8: No. 399 (E. Kl.) Also Deut. Zschr. gerichtl. Med., 1933-34, 22: p. i-iv (K. Meixner) Also Polska gaz. lek., 1933, 12: 1007 (L. Wach- holz) Also Wien. med. Wschr., 1933, 83: 1449 (von Neureiter) For portrait see Beitr. gerichtl. Med. 1928, 8: 1930, 10: HABERACKER, Wilhelm, 1908- *Die Gefahren und die Behandlung der iibertragenen Schwangerschaft und des Partus serotinus. 35p. 8? Heidelb., H. Fahrer, 1934. HABERER, Ernst, 1902- *Ueber einige Einwirkungen auf das vegetative Nervensystem bei elektrischer Reizung vom Magen-Darm- Kanal aus [Freiburg i. B.] p.220-41. 8? Berl., J. Springer, 1929. Also Zschr. ges. exp. Med., 1929, 69: HABERER, Hans, 1875- Verletzungen und Krankheiten des knochernen Schadels einschliesslich Kiefer und Nebenhohlen. 78p. 8? Lpz., G. Thieme, 1923. Forms Heft 5, Diagn. ther. Irrtiim. ---- Zur Operationsanzeige beim Magen- und Zwolffingerdarmgeschwiir. 19p. 8? Stuttg., F. Enke, 1936. Forms 9. Heft, Vortrage prakt. Chir. (Lexer, E.) HABERFELD, Magdalene. Ueber die Ver- farbung und Entfarbung gepresster Steinsalz- krystalle. p. 135-54. 8? Wien, Holder-Pichler- Tempsky, 1933. Forms Heft 308, Mitt. Inst. Radiumforsch. HABERKAMP, Marianne, 1905- *Still- wille und Stillfahigkeit bei arbeitenden Frauen. 44p. 8? Bonn, P. Rost, 1931. HABERKORN. Aerztlicher Rathgeber fur Gesunde und Kranke [2. Aufl.] xvi, 496n 8° N. Y., S. Zickel, 1885. HABERKORN, Richard, 1912- *Verlauf und Behandlung der krupposen Pneumonie [Heidelberg] 12p. 21cm. Munch., E. Miihl- thaler, 1937. Also Munch, med. Wschr., 1937, 84: HABERL, Friedrich, 1905- *Die Schmerz- hnderung in der Geburtshilfe. 46p. 8? Wurzb , C. J. Becker, 1932. HABERLAND, Hermann Franz Oskar, 1887- Die anaerobe Wundinfektion. xviii, 424d tab. 8? Stuttg., F. Enke, 1921. Forms Bd 27, Neue deut. Chir. (H. Kiittner) ---- Die operative Technik des Tierexperi- mentes. x, 336p. 8? Berl., J. Springer, 1926. HABERLAND 5 HABERMANN ---- The same. Die operative Technik des Tierexperimentes mit anatomischen und topo- graphischen Bemerkungen. xi, 434p. Must. 8? Berl., Urban & Schwarzenberg, 1934. Forms Abt 5, Teii 3 C, Handb. biol. Arbeitsmeth. (Abder- halden, E.) ---- Die Differentialdiagnose chirurgischer Erkrankungen einschliesslich der Grenzgebiete mit therapeutischen Hinweisen. xi, 1180p. Must. 8? Berl., W. de Gruyter & Co., 1935. HABERLAND, Werner, 1912- *Die Schulzahnpflege in Grimma [Marburg] 21p. 3 ch. map. 23cm. Bresl., R. Nischkowsky, 1936. HABERLANDT, Gunther [Heinz Paul] 1902- *Zur Pathogenese der radikularen Cvsten. 24p. 8? Berl., R. Pfau, 1935. HABERLANDT, Herbert. Lumineszenzunter- suchungen an Fluoriten. II. p.29-33. 8? Wien, Holder-Pichler-Tempsky, 1933. Forms Heft 303, Mitt. Inst. Radiumforsch., Wien. ---- & PRZIBRAM, Karl. Zur Fluoreszenz des Fluorits. p.235-9. pi. 8? Wien, Holder- Pichler-Tempsky, 1933. Forms Heft 313, Mitt. Inst. Radiumforsch., Wien. HABERLANDT, Ludwig, 1885- Das Hormon der Herzbewegung. 57p. 8? Berl., Urban & Schwarzenberg, 1927. ---- Das Herzhormon. 3 1. 64p. 8? Jena, G. Fischer, 1930. HABERLER, Franz, 1857-1928. Durig. Nekrolog. Wien. klin. Wschr., 1928, 41: 286. HABERLING, Wilhelm Gustav Moritz, 1871- 1940. Die Verwundetenfiirsorge in den Helden- liedern des Mittelalters. 51p. 8? Jena, G. Fischer, 1917. Forms Heft 10, Jena. Med. Hist. Beitr. (Meyer-Steineg, T.) ---- Johannes Miiller; das Leben des Rheini- schen Naturforschers. 3 p. 1. 501p. 9 pi. facs. roy. 8? Lpz., Akad. Verl., 1924. ---- German medicine. Transl. by Jules Freund. xiii, 160p. portr. 16? N. Y., P. B. Hoeber, 1934. Forms v. 13 of Clio medica (Krumbhaar, E. B.) ---- Die Geschichte der Diisseldorfer Aerzte und Krankenhauser bis zum Jahre 1907. 4, 168p. pi. portr. 8? Diisseld., E. Lintz, 1936. For biography see Med. Life, 1928, 35: 536-40, portr. Also Sudhoffs Arch., 1940, 33: front. (W. Brunn [et al.]) ---- & VIERORDT, H. Biographisches Lexikon der hervorragenden Aerzte aller Zeiten und Volker. 2. Aufl. v. 1-5, 1929-35. HABERMAAS, Albert, 1872-1933. Kieffer, R. S. [Biography] Week. Bull. S. Louis M. Soc, 1934, 29: 69. HABERMAN, Jules Victor, 1879- Guide- notes to the practice of medicine; a synopsis for students with a resum£ of the subject of inflam- mation. Pt 1. 184p. 8? N. Y., J. T. Dougherty 19Q5. ---- The finer diagnoses of acute brain in- volvement, inclusive of syphilis and brain injury. 2 p. 1. 116p. 8? N. Y., Med. J. & Rec. [1926] HABERMANN, Guenther, 1913- *Das Intermediagebiet der menschlichen Hypophyse [Berlin] p.560-81. 24}£cm. Naumb., Lippert & Co., 1938. HABERMANN, Hermann, 1910- *Ueber die Hypospadie beim Manne und ihre Behand- lung; mit besonderer Beriicksichtigung von 18 Fallen aus der Chirurgischen Universitiits- Poliklinik in Kiel [Kiel] 31p. 8? Gutersloh, Thiele, 1935. HABERMANN, Johann, 1849-1935. Hofer, G. Nekrolog. Arch. Ohr. &c. Heilk., 1935, 139: 315-20.—Mayer, O. Nekrolog. Mschr. Ohrenh., 1935, 69: 769-75, portr.—Mayer, O. Johann Habermann zum Ge- dachtnis. Zschr. Hals &c. Heilk., 1935-36, 39: 6-9. HABERMANN, R[udolf] 1884- Para- typische Pigmentanomalien (vorwiegend erwor- bene, durch endogene oder exogene Einfliisse zustande kommende Pigmentierungen und Depig- mentierungen) p.796-970. 8? Berl., 1933. In Handb. Haut Geschlkr. (Alexander, A. & G.) Berl., 1933, 4:pt2. HABERMANN, Valentin, 1909- *Ana- tomie der Weisheitszahne. 15p. 8? Wiirzb., Gebr. Memminger, 1934. HABERT, Max, 1905- *Le mode de transmission des leishmanioses. 47p. 8? Par., Jouve & cie, 1929. HABERT, Vera, 1910- *Das Vorhofflim- mern in seiner schnellen und langsamen Form. 15p. 8? Halle, E. Klinz, 1935. HABIB, Mounir, 1913- *Mongolisme infantile et syphilis. 80p. 25cm. Lyon, Paquet, 1938. HABIB, Sylvain Salomon, 1912- Contribu- tion a l'elude de la xanthomatose osseuse. 141p. pi. 8? Par., Jouve & cie, 1937. HABIBI, Mostapha, 1904- *La transil- lumination dans le diagnostic des tumeurs du sein. 126p. 8? Par., A. Legrand, 1935. HABICHT, Edith [geb. Windschild] 1896- *Ueber einen Fall von Perforation eines Gallen- steines im Stadium des Durchbruches in das Duodenum. 18p. 8? Lpz., A. Edelmann, 1926. HABICHT, Herbert, 1910- *Die Parulis nach 184 stationaren Beobachtungen an der chirurgischen Universitats-Klinik Leipzig. 28p. 8? Borna, R. Noske, 1934. HABICHT, Rolf, 1908- *Die naturarzt- liche Behandlung der Lungenentztindung. 44p. 25cm. Lpz., A. Edelmann, 1936. HABILD, Gunther, 1908- *Beitrage zur Frage der apoplectiform auftretenden Encepha- litis [Jena] 16p. 8? Zeulenroda, B. Sporn, 1934. HABIT. See also Adaptation; Animals, Psychology; Behavior; Character; Conditioned reflex; Crimi- nal; Disposition; Obsession. Basset, G. C. Habit formation in a strain of albino rats of less than normal brain weight. 46p. 8? N. Y. [1914] Bott, A. E., Blatz, E. W. [et al.] Observa- tion and training of fundamental habits in young children. 161p. 4? Worcester, 1928. Forms No. 1, vol. 4, Psychol. Monogr., 1928. McCiiNNis, E. The acquisition and inter- ference of motor habits in young children. p.203-311. 4? Worcester, 1929. In Genet. Psychol. Monogr., 1929, 6: Olson, W. C. The measurement of nervous habits in normal children. 97p. 8? Minneap. [1929] Berkeley-Hill, O. Habit formation. J. Ment. Sc, Lond., 1929, 75: 298.—Beverly, B. I. Habit formation. Proc. Inst. M. Chicago, 1938-39, 12: 443.—Blankinship, R. Habit. Virginia M. Month., 1941, 68: 282-5.—Bruce, J. W. Habit training and habit disorders. Kentucky M. J., 1939, 37: 70- 3.—Buytendijk, F. J. J., & Hage, J. Sur la valeur de reaction de quelques excitants sensoriels simples dans la formation d'une habitude par les chiens. Arch, neerl. physiol., 1923, 8: 215- 33.—Buytendijk, F. J. J., & Remmers, J. Nouvelles recherches sur la formation d'habitudes chez les poissons. Ibid., 165- 183.—Clark, L. P., & Uniker, T. E. An analytic study of stereotyped habit movements in children. Arch. Psychoanal., 1926-27, 1: 381-436.—Cohen, W. [Habit formation in infants] Mschr. kindergeneesk., 1931-32, 1: 182-208, 3 pi.—Diamond, S. Habit-formation under non-selective conditions. J. Comp. Psychol., 1934, 17: 109-48.—Dunlap, K. The revision of the fundamental law of habit formation. Science, 1928, 77: 360- 2. ------ Repetition in the breaking of habits. Sc. Month., HABIT 6 HABITATION 1930, 30: 66-70. Elision, I). G. Quantitative studies of the Interaction of simple habit.* recovery from specific and general- if.>d erT.-i-t.x of extinction. J. Exp. Psychol., I''is 23: 339-58.— Kvanw. S. I'le\ibilitt of established habit. I Gen. Psjcliol., I93ii. II: 177-200.- Fritz. M. F. Long-time i raining of white rats on antagonistic visual habit-. .1. Corap. I'~\ 'hoi., 1930, 11: 171 St. Funkhouser, W. I.. Serviceable habits. Arch. Pediat., X. V., 192S, 45: 538-IJ.- Gantt. W. H. Conditioned reflexes and hal>it formation. Brit. M. J.. 1032. 1: 517-9.— Urindley, G. C. The formation of a simple habit in guinea- pigs. Hrit. J. lV\.h..l , 1932. 23: 127.—Guillaume, P. Les i^piil-. a (Tec tiff, de I'liahitude. J. psychol. norm, path., Par., 1935. 32: 200-34- Hamburger, F. Peber psvrhische Ethismen. Arch. Kinderh., 19.34, 104: 92-4,------Die Bedeutung der 'Jewohnlicit in der kliuischen Pathologic Wien. klin. Wschr., 1935, 48: 97-100.—Hartman, C. The habits of Eumenes belfragei, Cress. J. Animal Behav., 1913, 3: 353-60—Hubbard, R. M. The stimulus for the visual discrimination habit. J. Comp. IN.vrhi.l., 1927, 7: 75-81.- Hunter, W. S. Habit inter- ference in tin- white rat and in human subjects. Ibid., 1922, 2: 29-59.—Johnson, L. R. Habits and their control during childhood. .1. Am. Dent. Ass., 1937, 24: 1409-21.—Lendle, L. Untersuchungen iiber den Mechanismus der Gewohnung: sind die isolierten Organe alkohol-gewohnter Frosche alkohol- resistenter? Arch. exp. Path., Lpz., 1927, 120: 129-43 — Lowrey, L. G. Psychologic care during early childhood from the standpoint of the pediatrician: habit 1raining. Am. J. Dis. Child., 1935. 49: 1080 2.— MacBride, E. W. Habit, the driving force in evolution. Proc. R. Inst. <3p. 8? Par., 192."). Kramer, R. *Ucber die keimtotende Wirkung der Bohnermasse Bakteriol. 24p. 8? Tub., 1933. Casagrandi, O., & Seppilli, A. L'azione antibatterica delle cere da pavimenti e la loro importanza nella tenuta igienica dei pavimenti. Osp. maggiore, Milano, 1937, 25: 510-8.—Ditthorn, F. I'eber desinfizierende Bohnerwachso. Zschr. ges. Kranken- hauswes., 1929. 25: 386 9.—Germ-free bathrooms; ultra-violet rays insure cleanliness. Sc. American, 1941, 164: 202.—Grier- eon, A. M. M. Bug infestations and disinfestation. Pub. Health, Lond., 1934-35, 48: 347-55—Ickert, F., Schaede, G., & Wilke, W. Ueber die Fussbodenreinigung vom bakteriolo- gischen Standpunkt aus. Zschr. Hyg.. 1927-28, 108: 382-91 — I.ehmann, K. B. Das Absterben von Kiterkokken auf Linoleum, Holz, Glas und (Imnnii unter Beriieksicht.igung von Licht und Temperatur. Arch. Hyg., Berl.. 1931, 106: 1-31.—• Mertens, H. Feldzug gegen YVohnungssehadlingo; Erfahrungen in England, Schweden, Oesterieich und Ungarn. Zschr. hyg. Zool., 1937, 29: 139; 170.—Missirini, M. La nettezza mezzo di salubrita dei luoghi abitati. Arch. sc. med. fis. toscane (1837-38) 1840, 1 : 191-506. Noziczka, F. Ueber das Verhalten von Triolin und Linoleum als Fussbodenbelag hinsichtlich der Abgabe von siesundheitsschadlichen Substanzen an die Raumluft. Arch. Ilvg., Miinch., 1926,97:47 81. Reichmuth.W. DieWolinungs- fischchen und ihre Bckainpfung. Zschr. hyg. Zool., 1936, 28: 65- 71.—Rosenhaupt cv Amling, H. Auftrcten von Schwefel- «asset st off nach einer YVohniingssanierung mit schwefliger Same. Zschr. Desinfekt., 1927, 19: 194-7.—Smorodinzev, A. A. Bakteriologische Begriindung der wichtigsten Methoden zur Desinfektion von Wohnraumen. Ibid., 1928, 20: 17; 42.— Troussaint. L'intergt primordial des peintures antiseptiques dans l'hygiene du batimentet plus spficialement des habitations collectives (sanatoria, casernes, hopitaux, 6coles, navires, etc.) Rapp. Congr. internat. hyg. mediter. (1932) 1933, 1. Congr., 2: 706-9.—Wilhelmi, J. Gesundheits- und Wohnungsschadlinge und ihre Bekampfung. Zschr. hyg. Zool., 1936, 28: 78-89. ---- Decoration, and furniture. Audouze, D. *Ameublement et decoration de l'habitation moderne et hygiene. 63p. 8? Lyon, 1934. Posner, L. *M6beltypen in hygieniseher Bcziehung [Berlin] 36p. 8? [Kirchhain] 1927. ---- Effect on inhabitants. See also Group, Diseases: Ktiology; also Housing. Borries, L. von. *Ueber das Leben in tiber- fullten Raumen [Heidelberg] 12p. 8? Diisseld. 1938. Fischer-Defoy, W. Wohnungschaden und Wohnungshygiene. 24p. 18? Dresd. [1920] Moury, R. *Le probleme medical des habi- tations insalubres. 47p. 24cm. Par., 1939. Acklin, O. Influences physiologiques et psychologiques de I habitation. Techn. san. mun., Par., 1933, 28: 347-52 — rV.rcet: d'.& Braconnot. Observations d'asphyxie lente due a 1 insalubrity des habitations, et, a des emanations metalliques. Gaz san., Par., 1836, 6: 255-61.—Einstein. Beziehungen der v\ ohnungsverhaltnisse zum Gesundheitszustand unserer Schul- kinder. Zschr. behulgesundh., 1929, 42: 437-9.—Kiss de Mad. in L,lntnuenza (1V lil costruzione e dellattrczzamento tecnico delle abitazioni sul a salute femminile. Atti Congr. internal. de VhTr r931, 2-/ 'T^ V :•.>:». HADJOIDJ, Mohamed, ISO.) Con- tribution a l'etude de la porigastrite lacunaire iles gast ro-cnterostomises. 37p. "2 1. S pi. 8? Par., Jouve A; cie, 192t>. HADJ-SAID, 1910 Contribution a l'etude des anevrismes aortiques; etude clinique de certaines formes atvpiques. 63p. 24cm. Par., Vigm', 1938. HADRICH. A-Z der arztlichen Organisa- tionskunde; Einfuhrung in das neue arztlichc Organisationswcsen [2. Aufl.] xii, 716p. 22^cm. [Lpz., (1. Thieme, 1937] Looselraf. HADROSSEK, Alfons, 1902- *Ueber die Wirkung von Bestrahlung auf die Giftempfind- lichkeit weisser Mause [Breslau] 21p. 2 1. 8°. Lpz., F. ('. \Y. Vogel, 1930. Also Arch. exp. Path., Berl., 1930, 155: HADWEN, Walter Robert, 1854-1932. The difficulties of Dr Deguerre. 596p. pi. portr. s? Lond., C. W. Daniels Co. [1926| See also Kidd, B. E., & Richards, M. E. Iladwen of Glou- cester; man, medico, martyr. 345p. 8? Lond. [1933] HAEBERLEIN, Alfred, 1911 *Kraft- quellen in der Orthodontic. 40p. 22cm. Ilcidelb., L. Geier, 1936. HAEBERLIN, Bernhard, 1909- *Ueber das (iriisscnverhaltnis der Elektrokardiogramm- ausschlage in den drei Extremitatenableitungen beim Xormalen. 14p. 2 pi. 8? Giessen, O. 1870- Lebensge- xii, 144p. 8? Lpz., C. vii, 181p. 8< Kindt, 1936. HAEBERLIN, Carl, schehen und Krankheit. Kabitzsch, 1926. ----Aerztliche Scclcnkunde. Lpz., J. A. Barth, 1928. ----Die Bedeutung leibseelischer Zusam- menhange fiir arztliches Handeln. 30p. 8? Lpz., H. Kornfeld, 1930. Forms H. 412, v.37, Berl. Klin. ---- Lebensrhythmen und Heilkunde; Ent- wurf ciner biozentrischen arztlichen Betrachtung. 74p. 8° Stuttg., Hippokrates-Verl., 1935. See aK(i Achelis, J. D., Haeberlin, C. [et al.] Philosophische Grenzfragen der Medizin. 114p. 8? Lpz., 1930. For biography see Deut. med. Wschr., 1940, 66: 1403, portr. (O. Riess) ----van OORDT, Marius (et al.] Klimatische Kuren im Winter. 134p. 8? Lpz., G. Thieme, 1928. HAEBERLIN, Carl & ROELOFFS, Fr. Die Meeres-Heilkunde in Deutschland. 64p. 23cm. Hamb., C. Griese [1938] HAEBERLIN, Ernst, 1907- *Aerztliche Untersuchungsergebnisse bei Ziircher Gewerbe- schulern. 27p. 8? Zur., O. Fiissli, 1934. HAEBERLIN, Lili, 1906- *Erfahrungen mit der Insulin-Glukose-Wasserbclastung nach Althauscn-Mancke als Lcberfunktionspriifung. 35p. 8? Ziir., Fluntcrn, 1934. HAEBLER, Carl, 1894- *Untersuchungen zur Molekularpatholosde des experiment lien Diinndai mverschlusses zugleich ein Beitrag zur Technik der Pfortader-Angiostomie und zur pathologist-hen Physiologic dei W'asseientziehuiif; [Habililationschrift; Wurzburg] p.524-77. 8° Berl., J. Springer, 1926. [AJso Zschr. ges. exp. Med., 1927, 54: ---- Physikalisch-chemische Probleme in der Chirurgie. viii, 274p. 8? Berl., J. Springer, 1930. ----Physiko-chcmische Medizin, nach Hein- rich Schade. vii, 224p. in el. illust. diagr. 241icm. Drcsd., T. Steinkopff, 1939. HAEBLER, Use, 1907- Cebor patho- logisch-anatomische, bakteriologische und klini- sche Beobachtungen an 53 Sopsis-Todesfallen nach Abort [Breslau] 32p. 22cm. Tub., II. Laupp, jr., 1937. HAEBLER, Konrad, 1857- For portrait see collection in library. HAEBLER, Tatjana von, 1901- *Ucbcr den PJinfluss von Moor- und Fangopackungen auf die Hautoberflachentemperatur des Menschen. 24p. 8? [Jena, n. pub.] 1927. HAECKEL, Ernst, 1834-1919. Kwigkeit; Weltkriegsgedanken iiber Leben und Tod, Religion und Entwicklungslehre. 128p. 8? Berl., W. de Grunter & Co., 1919. ---- Entwicklungsgeschichte einer Jugend; Briefe an die Eltern, 1S52-56. viii, 216p. portr. 8? Lpz., K. F. Koehler, 1921. For portrait see Bcitr. Klin. Tubcrk., 1936, 88: H. 5, front. See also Hauser, K. Ernst Haeckcl; sein Leben, sein Wirken und seine Bedeutung fiir den Gristeskampf der Gegenwart. 147p. 8? Godesbreg, 1920.—Heberer, G. Ernst Hreckel und seine wissenschaftliche Bedeutng. 32p 8? Lpz., 1934.— Maurer, F. Das Gehirn Ernst Hseckels, mit einem Bericht von Waldemar Weinmann, iiber den histologischen Befund des Gehirns Heeckels. 60p. fol. Jena, 1924.—Schmidt, H. Ernst Haeckel, Leben und Werke, 446p. 12? Berl. 11926] For biography see Med. Klin., Berl., 1934, 30: 250 (L. draper) Also Nature, Lond., 1934, 133: 198 (E. W. MacBride) Also Riforma med., 1934, 50: 747 (V. M. Palmieri) Also Umschau, 1934, 38: 126-8 (H. Weinert) Also Zschr. indukt. Abstamm., 1935, 70: 541-6 (G. Heberer) HAECKEL, Ernst Gunther, 1905- *Zur Behandlung der Prostatahypertrophie und des Prostatacarcinoms [Breslau] 23p. 21cm. Bie- sengebirge, Hirschberg, 1937. HAECKER, Valentin, 1864-1927. Pluripotenz- erscheinungen, synthetische Beitrage zur Verer- bungs- unci Abstammungslehre. viii, 213p. 8? Jena, G. Fischer, 1925. ----Methoden der Vcrerbungsforschung beim Menschen. p.93-192. 8? Berl., 1937. In Handb. biol. Arbeitsmeth. (Abderhalden, E.) Berl., 1937, Abt. 9, T. 3. 1. Halfte. For biography see Med. Klin., Berl. Haberlandt) 1928, 24: 319 (L. HAEDENKAMP, Karl [Christian Friedrich Hermann] 1889- Das Arztrecht; Gesetze, Verordnungen, Erlasse, Anordnungen, Vertrage und organisatorische Angaben aus dem Arbeits- gebiet der Reichsarztekammer und der Kassen- arztlichen Vereinigung Deutschlands. 218p. 8? Berl., Langewort, 1937. Also editor of Aerztliche Mitteilungen nebst Anzeiger. Lpz., v.27-29, 1926-28. HAEDICKE, Diethelm, 1901- *Die operative Behandlung spondylitischer Lahmun- gen durch Laminektomie. 24p. 2 1. 8? Marb., Bauer, 1928. HAEDICKE, Johannes. Des Menschen Wille ist frci; biologischc Bemerkungen zu der Einheit der Fcrsonlichkeit und der Einheit der Kausalitat. 5NP. 24y2cm. Lpz., O. Hillmann [1937] HAEDKE, Kurt [Richard Eduard] 1904- ' Ueber die bakterienschadigende Eigenschaft der Frauenmilch [Tubingen] 14p. 3 1. 8° Borna R. Xoske, 1929. HAEDUS, Petrus, fl. ca 1490. Anterotica; de amoris generibus. 104 1. 8? Treviso, Gcrardus Lisa, 1492. HAEFELE 11 HAEGG HAEFELE, Helmut, 1911- *Zwillings- geburten und intrauterine Wachstumsdifferenzen. 35p. 8? Tub. [n. pub.] 1935. HAEFELI, Emil. * Ueber Vierlingsgeburten im Anschluss an einen neuen Fall (Schweizerische Statistik von 1871-1920) [Basel] 45p. 8? Stuttg. [n. pub.] 1926. Also Zschr. Geburtsh. Gyn., 1926, 89: H. 3. HAEFEN, Klaus von, 1905- *I)as Schick- sal der appendicitischen Exsudate; eine Studic auf Grund von 410 in der Chirurgischen Universi- tats-Klinik zu Gottingen in den Jahren 1912- 26 einschliesslich behandelten Fallen. 30p. 8? Grone (Kr. Gottingen) A. Schonhiitte & Sohnen, 1929 HAEFFNER, Fritz, 1905- *Der Foetor ex ore und seine Behandlung mit Fohydol M. 15p. 22cm. [Heidelb., n. pub.] 1935. HAEFKER, Carl Erich, 1912- *Der Doctor medicinae dentariae an der Universitat Heidelberg (unter Beriicksichtigung der Entwick- lung des zahnarztlichen Standes) [Heidelberg] 15p. 8? Ludwigshafen, J. Langenstein, 1937. HAEFLIGER, Eduard. Cymphomata colli tuberculosa [Basel] 54p. 8? Olten, Dietschi & cie, 1936. ---- Experimentelle und klinische Ergebnisse mit der Friedmannschen Tuberkulosevaccine. 156.p. illust. 25cm. Lpz., G. Thieme, 1938. Forms H. 21, Prakt. Tuberk.-Bucherei (K. Klare) HAEFLIGER, Emil. *Metastische Spatperi- tonitis nach stumpfer Verletzung des Bauch- felles; Beitrag zur Kenntnis des Locus minoris resistentiae. 27p. 8? Basel, F. Reinhardt, 1926. HAEFLIGER, Josef Anton. Pharmazeutische Altertumskunde und die Schweizerische Samm- lung fiir Historisches Apothekenwesen an der Universitat Basel. 203p. 32 pi. 8? Basel, B. Wepf & cie, 1931. HAEFLIGER, Julius. *Ueber Nirvanolbe- handlung der Chorea minor nebst Bemerkungen der Nirvanolwirkung iiberhaupt [Basel] 22p. 8? Escholzmatt, M. Arnold, 1930. HAEFNER, A[enne] 1909- *Uebcr die Blutdruckdifferenz an Arm und Bein [Wurzburg] 7p. 8? Wertheim, E. Bechstein, 1936. HAEFNER, Karl, 1914- , & WILDE, Willi, 1912- *Eine Methode zur Bestimmung der Chronaxie des Schmerzes [Heidelberg] lip. 21cm. Ludwigshafen, J. Waldkirch & cie, 1937. HAEFNER, Ralph, 1894- *The educa- tional significance of left-handedness [Columbia Univ.] 84p. 8? N. Y., Teachers Coll., 1929. HAEGE, Ernst, 1911- *Ueber endokrani- elle Verwicklungen infolge akuter Mittelohrent- ziindung bei Residuen. 23p. 20J4cm. Erlangen, K. Dores, 1937. HAEGELE, Elisabeth, 1910- *Versuche iiber die Moglichkeit der Instrumenten-Sterilisa- tion mit Formaldehyddampfen in der arztlichen und zahnarztlichen Praxis. 18p. 8? Tiib., E. Gobel, 1933. HAEGELE, Ingeborg, 1911- *Ein neuer Odontomfall eigener Beobachtung [Tubingen] 22p. 8? Boblingen, R. Schlecht, .1936. HAEGER, Horst, 1912- Untersuchun- gen iiber die morphologische Beschaffenheit der Spermien (Ejakulatuntersuchungen von fertilen Mannern im Vergleich zu Spermienuntersuchun- gen bei Mannern, die unter das Gesetz zur Ver- hiitung des erbkranken Nachwuchses fallen) 31p. 23cm. Berl., C. Walter, 1938. HAEGG, Daniel, 1881-1939. Lichtenstein, A. [Obituary] Tskr. mil. halsov., 1939, 64: 181, portr. HAEGGQVIST, Gosta Per Engelbert, 1891- Die Gewebe. 3. T.: Gewebe und Systeme der Muskulatur. vi, 247p. 8? Berl., J. Springer, 1931. Forms v.2-3, Handb. mikr. Anat. Menschen (von Mollcn- dorff) Berl., 1927-31. HAEGGSTROEM, Paul [Robert] 1888-1934. *Bidrag till skoldkortelns aldersanatomi hos kaninen jamte nagra iakttagelser ofver den s. k. centralkanalen [Contribution to the develop- ment of the thyroid gland in rabbits, with some remarks on the so-called central canals] p.217- 384. 2 pi. 8? Upsala, E. Berling, 1915. For biography see Hygiea, Stockh., 1934, 96: 369-71, portr. (C. D. Josephson) Also P. verb. Congr. Soc. internat. chir., 1936, 10. Congr., 1: 210. HAEGLER, Adolf, 1864-1926. Massini, R. Nekrolog. Schweiz. med. Wschr., 1926, 56: 257. HAEGNI, Ernst, 1910- *Volvulus des Mesenterium ileo-coecale commune in der Schwangerschaft [Zurich] 39p. 23cm. Chur, Sprecher, Eggerling & Co., 1939. HAEHL, Erich. See Haehl, Richard, & Haehl, Erich. Gynakologie und Homoopathie. 172p. 8? Stuttg., 1935. HAEHL, Richard, -1933, & HAEHL, Erich. Gynakologie und Homoopathie mit Beriicksich- tigungder Sterilitat. 172p. illust. 8? Stuttg., Hippokrates, 1935. HAEHL, Richard M. See Winans, William W., Haehl, Richard M., & Thorpe, Jarvis L. Quiz-compend on surgery [&c.l 388p. 8? Phila., 1898. HAEHLE [Karl Moritz] Gerhard, 1911- *Ueber die Sanierung perforierter Zahne durch das Elfenbein und ihre Verwendung in der prothetischen Zahnheilkunde. 27p. 23cm. Berl., K. & R. Hoffmann, 1938. HAEHNER, Eduard, 1906- *Ergebnisse von Stirnhohlenoperationen; eine statistische Bearbeitung der in den Jahren 1923-1928 operierten Falle. 25p. tab. 8? Walldorf, F. Lamade, 1931. HAEHNERT [Karl August] Hugo, 1909- *Ueber den Einfluss der Vitamine auf das Zahnwachstum, auf die Umgebung der Zahne und auf die Zahnerhaltung. 36p. 21cm. Erlangen, K. Dores, 1938. HAEHNLE, Marielise, 1900- *Ueber nicht diagnostizierte Meningiome der Olfacto- riusgrube und die Grtinde der Fehldiagnose. 31p. 8? Bonn, H. Schonershoven, 1934. HAEHNLEIN, Friedrich Karl, 1889- *Die Behandlung der Torsio uteri beim Rinde durch einfaches Ausziehen des Foetus. 50p. 8°. Lpz., A. Edelmann, 1925. HAELSOVAENNENS flygskrifter. Stockh., Xos 1-2; Nos 4-9; Nos 11-16; No. 21, 1892-99. HAEMAELAEINEN, Juho. *Ueber das Ver- halten der alicyklischen Verbindungen bei der Glykuronsaurepaarung im Organismus [Univ. Finnland] 88p. 8? Lpz., Veit & Comp., 1912. HAEMAMOEBA. See Haemoproteidae; Plasmodium. HAEMAPHYSALIS. See also Acarina; Ixodidae; also under names of diseases transmitted as Babesiasis; Piro- plasmosis; Rickettsia, &c. Gear, J., & de Meilion, B. The common dog tick Hae- maphysalis leachi as a vector of tick typhus. S. Afr. M. J., 1939, 13: 815.—Gear, J. H. S.. & Douthwaite, M. The dog HAEMAPHYSALIS 12 IIAEMEL tick Ha-maphvsalis leachi as .1 vector of tick typhus. Ibid., 193S, 12: 53-5. Also repr.- Knuth. P. Weitere Mitteilungen iiber Haemaphysalis cinnal>;n m;i und iiber umfangreichc Blutungen in die Muskulatm beim Rinde. Berl. tierarztl. Wschr., 1914, 30: 825-7.—Larson. C. L. The tick parasite, Ixodiphagus texanus in nymph* and larvae of Haemaphysalis lrporis palustiis in Minnr-ma. .1. Parasit., Lancaster, 1937, 23: 496-8. Mesnard, J., <& ToumanofT, ('. Agent infectieux de genre Kiekettsia, mi.- en evidence chez une tique, Hae- maphysalis hispinosa Neuiiiiinn, ^cm. Miinch., J. F. Lehmann, 1934-38. In Lehmanns med. Atl., 5. Aufl., Bd 7. See also Kok, E., & Meyer, H. Professor Dr Fedor Hae- nisch, zu seinem 65. Geburtstage am 21. August 1939. Strah- lentherapie, 1939, 66: 185-8, portr. — HOLTHUSEN, H., & LIECHTI, A. Einfuhrung in die Rontgenologie; ein Lehrbuch fiir Aerzte und Studierende. xv, 359p. illust. roy. 8? Lpz., G. Thieme, 1933. HAENKE 14 HAERTEL MAENKE, Taddaus, 1761-1 SI7. iiicklhom. J. Vom arztlichen Wirken des sudetendeutschen N'aturforschero Thaddiius Haenke (1761-1817) in Sudamerika; Notizen zur Geschichte der Blattern-Schutzimpfung und der Tollwut-Bekampfung. Sudhoffs Arch., 1939, 32: 284-90. HAENSCH, Wilhelm. 1910- *12 Jahre Kieferbruchbehandlung an der Chirurgischen Universitats-Klinik zu Gottingen [Gottingen] 31p. 8? Osnabriick, A. Baranowski, 1936. HAENSt HE, Adolf, 1910- Teber habi- tuelles Hydramnion [Munster] 19p. 21cm. Quakenbriick, R. Kleinert, 1936. HAENSEL, Fritz, 1903- *Tierexperi- mentelle Studien iiber Nebenschilddriisenfunk- tion; X- Stoffwechsel. 36p. 8? Halle, O. Jung, 1930. HAENSEL, Giinter, 1908- *Die Spiit- folgen von Kampfgasvergiftungen an den Lungen und ihre versorgungsrechtliche Bewertung [Frei- burg] 14p. 8? Lippstadt, Thiele, 1934. HAENSEL [Kurt] Rudolf, 1913- Teber die Hautveranderungen, die durch isotonische Kochsalzlosung an den Fingern hervorgerufen werden. 12p. 23}£cm. Lpz., A. Edelmann, 1937. HAENSEL [Otto Heinrich] Gunther, 1909 * Ueber Xeuritiden und Myelitiden nacli Grippe [Leipzig] 34p. 23J<£cm. Zeulenroda, A. Oberreuter, 1937. HAENSGEN, Giinter, 1907- *Statis- tische Betrachtung beziehungsweise der in den Jahren 1920-1933 an der Universitats-Haut- klinik Berlin beobachteten Falle von Lues. 16p. 8? Berl., R. Pfau, 1935. HAENTZSCHEL, Adolph [Theodore Esaias] Learning to know the child; an introduction to child psychology, vii, 86p. 19cm. S. Louis, Concordia Pub. House;, 1941. HAENTZSCHEL [ArnoJ Kurt, 1910- *Die eugenische Bedeutung der angeborenen Spalt- bildungen im Bereiche von Lippe, Kiefer und Gaumen; ein Beitrag zum Ciesetz zur Verhiitung erbkranken Nachwuchses. 91p. 8? Lpz., A. Edelmann, 1935. HAERDI, E. *Die klinischen zahnarztlichen Materialien in bezug auf ihre Rontgendurchlas- sigkeit. 68p. 7 pi. 8? Ziir., 1935. HAERIG, Will, 1905- *Ein Beitrag zur Lehre einiger seltener Erbkrankheiten der Haut- decke. 20p. 8? Berl. [n. pub.] 1935. HAERING, Max, 1909- *Ueber die Brombestimmung im Blute [Erlangen] 15p. 22cm. Kallmiinz, M. Lassleben, 1935. HAERLE, Franz, 1909- *Oesophagus- carcinom auf dem Boden eines Cardiospasmus? Kip. 8° Tiib., A. Becht, 1936. HAERLIN, Fritz, 1911- *Beeinflusst das mannliche Sexualhormon den Cholesteringehalt des Blutserums? [Heidelberg] 16p. 21cm. Mannheim-Sandhofen, K. Kessler, 1937. HAERNING, Georg, 1890- *Ueber das Spitzenpigment bei Kindern. 47p. 8? Er- langen, Hofer & Limmert, 1927. HAERTEL, Friedrich Ferdinand, 1S77-, "■ Teehnik der Autovakzine-Bereitung [Jena] 32p. S° Borna. R. X'oske, 1936. HAERTEL, Wolfgang [Paul] 1905- *Ueber die antirachitische Wirksamkeit von bestrahlter Milch [Munster] 28p. 8? Diisseld., G. H. Xolte, 1934. HAERTER, Hans, 1909- *Die Deck- schicht der Speiserolne von Katze und Hund; unter Beriicksichtigung der durch die mechanisch Inanspruchnahme bedingten Erscheinungen [Halle] 17p. 8? Lpz., Akad. Verlag, 1932. Also Zschr. mikr. anat. Forsch., 1932, 31: HAERTL, Josef. Die Vererbung des Kryptor- chismus beim Hund. 2 p. 1. 45p. fold. tab. diagr. 24#cm. Lpz., P. Schops, 1938. HAERTLE, Hermann, 1908- *Ueber die quantitative Bestimmung der 3-Oxybuttersaure im Harn [Miinchen] 18p. 8? Kallmiinz, M. Lassleben, 1934. HAESELER, Kurt W., 1901- *A syste- matic study of the solubility of benzoic acid in salt solutions [Columbia Univ.] 28p. 8? N. Y. [n. pub.] 1929. HAESER, Heinrich, 1811-84. Lehrbuch der Geschichte der Medicin und der epidemischen Krankheiten. 3. Aufl. 3v. 8? Jena, H. Dufft, 1875—82 HAESNER, Gerd, 1913- *Haben die Zahngranulome eine Beziehung zur Allergie? [Greifswald] 27p. 8? Lengerich, Handelsdr. [1936] HAESSIG, Alice. *Ein eigenartiger Fall angeblich traumatischer Kontrakturen [Basel] 23p. 8? Laupen, Polygraph. Ges., 1932. HAESSLER, Erich. Die giftarmen Ruhr- bazillen; ein Beitrag zur Aetiologie der Durch- fallsstorungen im Sauglings- und Kindesalter sowie zur Namengebung, Epidemiologic und Prophylaxe der Ruhr. 68p. roy. 8? Berl., S. Karger, 1935. Forms H. 39, Abh. Kinderh. HAESSLER, Gerhard, 1908- *Vorkom- men und Art von Kropferkrankungen im nord- ostlichen Harzvorland (nach Beobachtungen von Quedlinburg aus) sowie ortliche Faktoren, die fiir deren Aetiologie geltend gemacht werden konnen. 26p. 8? Halle, E. Klinz, 1935. HAESSLER, Leonie, 1908- *Considera- tions sur les incisions du col pendant l'accouche- ment. 87p. 8? Strasb., C. & J. Goeller, 1935. HAESTIER, Richard Emile, 1899- Dead men tell tales; a survey of exhumations, from earliest antiquity to the present day. 2 1. 288p pi. portr. 8? Lond., J. Long [1934] HAETTENSCHWILLER, Oscar, 1897- *Zur diagnostischen Bedeutung der Umbauzonen (Looser) 24p. 8? Zur. [n. pub.] 1929. HAEUPL, Karl. Paradenitis marginalis (His- topathologic, Aetiologie, Klinik, Therapie und Prophylaxe) 3 p. 1. 320p. 8? Oslo, Fabritius & S0nner, 1926. See also Andresen, Viggo, & Haupl, Karl. Funktions-Kie- ferorthopadie. 116p. 8? Lpz., 1936. Also 2. Aufl. 152p 1939 HAEUSELE, Friedrich, 1894- *Zahn- studie: IX. Ueber den Schmelz von Beuteltieren p.484-96. 8? Miinch., 1932. Also Zschr. Zellforsch., 1932, 16: HAEUSLER, Charlotte, 1909- *Detavit in der Augenhe'ilkunde [Wurzburg] 24n 21cm Erlangen, K. Dores, 1937. P" HAEUSLER, Erhard, 1908- *Versuche uber die Beeinflussung des Arthus'schen Phiino- mens mit Bienengift. 43p. 22cm. Wiir/h Tf Mayr, 1937. "•' u- HAEUSLER HAEUSLER, Oskar, 1911- *Seltene Missbildungen der Mundhohle. 44p. 8? Bonn, Gebr. Scheur, 1935. HAEUSSER, Albert, 1911- *Ueber die Entartungen des Ductus thyreoglossus [Miin- chen] 35p. 21cm. Stuttg., A. Spottle, 1938. HAEUSSER, Kurt, 1908- *Die Erken- nung von Hiebverletzungen, insbesondere Axt- und Beilhiebe, auf Grund der Sammlungen des Institutes fiir gerichtliche Medizin in Diisseldorf [Miinster] 28p. 8? Diisseld., Kolditz, 1933. HAEUSSERMANN, Friedrich Wilhelm, 1907- *Ein Fall von malignem Haemangioendo- theliom der Leber. 15p. 8? Tub. [n. pub.] 1934. HAEUSSERMANN, Martin, 1913- *Zur Wechselbeziehung von Calcium und Phosphat. 24p. 21cm. Tub., Bolzle, 1937. HAEUSSERMANN, Otto, 1907- *Genese und Therapie des Lupus elephantiasticus [Frei- burg] 18p. 8? Quakenbriick, C. Trute, 1930. HAEUSSINGER, Eduard, 1903- *Ueber Angiome der Zunge und des Rachens [Erlangen] 24p. 8? Schweinfeld, G. Weltz, 1930. HAEUSSINGER, Wilhelm, 1908- *Ueber Kiefer- und Zahnanomalien bei Kindern der Erlanger Hilfsschule [Erlangen] 24p. 21}£cm. Wiirzb., K. Triltsch, 1938. HAEUSSLER, Georg [Friedrich] 1904- *Ueber Melanombildungen bei Bastarden von Xiphophorus helleri und Platypoecilus maculatu? var. rubra. [Heidelberg] 20p. 8? Mainz, J. Falk & Sonne, 1928. HAEUSSLER, Gerhard, 1912- *Ueber die Bestandigkeit der weissen Edelmetallegierung Pedagan und des Nickelins bei Verwendung in der Kieferorthopadie [Leipzig] 51 p. 22cm. Freib. i. B., T. Kehrer, 1936. HAEUSSLER [Kurt Louis] Werner, 1913- *Histochemischer Nachweis von normalen Blei in bleibenden Zahnen und Kieferknochen von Hund und Katze. 16p. 23cm. Lpz., A. Edel- mann, 1937. HAEUSSLER, Otto, 1910- Untersu- chungen iiber Leitungsanaesthesie am Kopf de? Hundes. 36p. 8? Lpz., A. Edelmann, 1934. HAEUSSLER, Theodor, 1912- *Herz- tamponade nach Aortenruptur mit einem eigenen Fall [Heidelberg] 12p. 8? Wiirzb., K. Triltsch, 1937. HAEUTEMANN, Max, 1903- *Die sogenannte idiopathisehe Pleuritis exsudativa tuberculosa [Berlin] p.483-91. roy. 8? Lpz., J. A. Barth, 1929. Also Zschr. Tuberk., 1929, 52: HAEVECKER, Heinz, 1908- ♦Unter- suchungen iiber die Verbesserung der Kaufahig- keit mit vollstandigem Zahnersatz durch Ein- schleifen im Gelenkbahnartikulator. 22p. 8? Frankf. a. M., L. Baum, 1933. HAEVECKER, Theodor, 1907- *Histo- logie und Genese von Pulpapolypen. 17p. 2 pi. 8? Wiirzb., M. Hofmann, 1935. HAFAZALLA, Karam, 1898- *Ueber Witterungseinfliisse im Verlauf akuter Glomerulo- nephritis. 25p. 8? Freib. i. B., Gebr. Gunther, 1932. HAFEN, Rudolf, 1913- *Die Vitalitat des Schmelzes. 28p. 8? Miinch., R. Mayr, 1937. HAFERBIER, Anita, 1901- *Ueber Blut- gruppen bei schizophrenen Familien [Miinchen] 27p. 8? Borna, R. Noske, 1929. HAFERKORN, Martin, 1907- *Ueber Beziehungen zwischen Sekretionsstorungen und HAFERKORN Krankheitssitz bei chronischer Gastritis. 27n 8? [Lpz., E. Wohlleben] 1931. HAFERMALZ, Erich, 1908- *Die Ergeb- nisse der Schiefhalsoperationen vom Jahre 1919- 34 an der Chirurgischen Universitatsklinik Halle- Wittenberg. 26p. 8? Halle, E. Klinz, 1935. HAFEZ, Nigm Eldin, 1905- *Ueber den Blutdruck bei der chronischen Lungentuberkulose [Leipzig] 15p. 8? Zeulenroda, A. Oberreuter, 1931. HAFEZ Bandaly, Alphonse, 1910- *Sur un cas de maladie de Hodgkin avec anemie grave 53p. 8? Par., L. Rodstein, 1935. HAFF, Karl. Rechtspsychologie; Forschungen zur Individual- und Massenpsychologie des Rechts und zur modernen Rechtsfindung. p 1- 118. 8? Berl., 1935. In Handb. biol. Arbeitsmeth. (Abderhalden, E.) Berl.. 1935. Abt. 6, Teil C. II, 1 (Bd 2) HAFF disease. See also Fisherman; Hemoglobinuria; Resin acid. Assmann, H., Bielenstein, H. [et al.] Beobachtungen und Untersuchungen bei der Haffkrankheit 1932. Deut med Wschr., 1933, 59: 122-6.—Burgers, J. Ueber die Haffkrank- heit. Veroff. Medverwalt.. 1933, 41: 1-35. Also Schr Konigsberg. gelehrt. Ges., 1934,11: 31-42.—Ewig.W. Sammel- referat iiber die Haffkrankheit. Deut. med. Wschr., 1924 50: 1776-8.—Flury, F. Das Problem der Haffkrankheit. Klin Wschr., 1933, 12: 1161-3.—Gaehlinger. Une nouvelle maladie: la maladie du golfe. Paris med., 1924, 53: 529.—Gosio, B. Sul cosi detto morbo del Frisches Haff di Danzica. Policlinico, 1925, 32: sez. prat., 161-4.—Habs, H. Zur Epidemiologic der Haffkrankheit. Zschr. klin. Med., 1933, 125: 431-52 — [Haffkrankheit] Deut. med. Wschr., 1924, 50: 1420.—Hie- ronymi, E. Ueber die Haffkrankheit des Menschen und der Tiere. Deut. tierarztl. Wschr., 1933, 41: 1-5.—Lawetzky. Ueber eine neue Krankheit: die Haffkrandheit. Zschr. arztl Fortbild., 1924, 21: 654.------Die Haffkrankheit. Deut. med. Wschr., 1924, 50: 1444; 1925, 51: 131.—Lentz, O. Ueber die Haffkrancheit. Med. Klin., Berl., 1925, 21: 4-8.------■ Wiederausbruch der Haffkrankheit. Med. Welt, 1932, 6: 1565. ------ Ein neuer Ausbruch der Haffkrankheit. Volks- wohlfahrt, 1932, 13: 892-6.—Lewin, L. Untersuchungen an Haffischern mit Haffkrankheit. Deut. med. Wschr., 1925, 51: 133.—Lockemann, G. Zur Haffkrankheit. Med. Welt, 1932 6: 1669-71.—Rosencrantz, H. Die Haffkrankheit. Med. Klin., Berl., 1924, 20: 1802.—Rosenow, G., & Tietz, L. Die Haffkrankheit. Klin. Wschr., 1924, 3: 1991-3.—Schittenhelm, A. Haffkrankheit. In Handb. inn. Med. (Bergmann, G. let al.]) Berl., 1934, 1: 1018-25.—Seeger, F., & Tidow, G. Klini- sche Beobachtungen iiber eine ungewohnliche Ei krankung unter den Fischern des Frischen Haffes. Miinch. med. Wschr., 1924, 71: 1455- 7.—Stoeltzner, W. Akute und chronische Haffkrank- heit. Deut. med. Wschr., 1933, 59: 728.—Wagner, G. [Haff- krankheit] Munch, med. Wschr., 1924, 71: 1828.—Wigand, R., & Steiner, F. Weitere Untersuchungen iiber den Wurmbefall des Menschen am Kurischen Haff. Deut. med. Wschr., 1933, 59: 1119-21.—Zu Jeddeloh, B. Die Haffkrankheit. Med. Welt, 1938, 12: 811-3. Also Sil/.ber. Phys. med. Soz. Erlangen (1938) 1939, 70: 69-72. Also Krg. inn. Med. Kinderh., 1939, 57: 138-82. ____Etiology. Wolter, F. Die Entstehungsursachen der Haffkrankheit, in dem Zeitraum von 1924-33 vom epidemiologischen Standpunkt. 56p. 8? Stuttg., 1936. Bachmann, W. Experim en telle Beitriige zur Aetiologie der Haffkrankheit. Arch. Hyg., Munch., 1933-34, 111: 214-31. ------Hettche, H. O., & Ogait, A. Experimentelle Beitragc zur Aetiologie der Haffkrankheit. Ibid., 1933, 110: 266; 303.— Burgers, Bachmann & Hettche. Experimentelle Unter- suchungen iiber die Ursache der Haffkrankheit. Deut. med. Wschr., 1933, 59: 53.—Danneel, R. Ein biologischer Nach- weis von Abietinsaure und ihren Stammsubstanzen und seine Anwendung auf die Untersuchung von Sulfitzellstoffabwassern. Arch. exp. Path., Berl., 1934-35, 177: 248-59.—Eichholtz, F. Ursache der Haffkrankheit. Deut. med. Wschr., 1932, 58: 1932-4.—Flury, F. Die Haffkrankheit, eine Ueberempfind- lichkeit gegen Schlammstoffe? Klin. Wschr., 1935, 14: 1273- 5.—Fortner, J., Otto, K., & von Biilow, B. F. Versuche zur Aetiologie der Haffkrankheit. Deut. med. Wschr., 1933, 59: 766. Also Zschr. Hyg., 1933, 115: 390-405.—Haupt, H., & Runke, A. Vergiftung von Rindern nach Aufnahme von Schilf, das mit fauligen Fischteilen behaftet war. Zschr. Veterinark., 1926, 38: 50-4.—Joachimoglu, G., & Spinner, J. R. Experimenteller Beitrag zur Aetiologie der Haffkrankheit. 16 HAFT HAFF DISEASE Deut. med. Wschr., 1925, 51: 1483.—Lentz, O. Xoch einiges iiber die Haffkrankheit. Arb. Reichsgesundhamt., 1926, 57: 189-97. ------ Zur Aetiologie der Haffkrankheit. Miinch. med. Wschr., 1926, 73: 956.—Lockemann, G. Ist die Arsen- hvpothese fur die Haffkrankheit noch aufrecht zu erhalten? Deut. med. Wschr., 1928, 54: 1071 4. ------ Chemische Untersuchungen zur Haffkrankheit; Beitrage zur Beurteilung der Arsenhypothese. Biochem. Zschr., 1929, 207: 194-216. ------Boecker, E., & von Biilow, B. F. Dritter Bericht iiber die Erforschung der Haffkrankheit. Veroff. Medverwalt., 1930, 32: 77-192.—Sampietro, G. La malattia della rada. Ann. igiene, 1925, 35: 65-8.— Seller, H. Haffkrankheit und Abwasser der Stadt Konigsberg. Gesundh. Ingenieur, 1926, 49: 409-13. ------ Xochmals zur Aetiologie der Haffkrankheit. Miinch. med. Wschr., 1926, 73: 993.—Steiner. Die Epidemiologic und Aetiologie der sogenannten Haffkrank- heit. Med. Klin., Berl., 1925, 21: 266.—Stoeltzner, W. Die Ursache der Haffkrankheit. Deut. med. Wschr., 1932, 58: 1929-32.—Wieland, H. Zur Frage nach der Ursache der Haffkrankheit. Klin. Wschr., 1926, 5: 365. ____ Pathology. Kntjth, H. *Die Veranderungen der quer- gestreiften Muskulatur bei der Haffkrankheit. 31p. 8? Konigsb., 1933. Assmann, H., Bielenstein, H. [et al.] Befunde am Riicken- mark bei der sogenannten Haffkrankheit der Katzen. Deut. med. Wschr., 1933, 59: 367.—Meyer, S. Haffkrankheit und paralytische Hamoglobinurie der Pferde; identische Krank- heitszustande. Klin. Wschr., 1924, 3: 2189.—Paul, F. Zur Frage der Haffkrankheit; Beitrag zur Systematik der degenera- tiven Muskelerkrankuiifrcn beim Menschen und Tier. Ibid., 1925, 4: 166.—Volker, R. Ueber die Beziehungen der Haff- krankheit der Menschen zur Hamoglobinurie der Tiere. Zschr. Infektkr. Haustiere, 1928, 33: 147-70. HAFFERL, Anton, 1886- Das Arterien- system. p.563-684. roy. 8? Berl., 1931-33. In Handb. vergl. Anat. (Ellenberger, W. [et al.]) Berl., 1931-33, 6: HAFFKINE, Waldemar Mordecai Wolff, 1860- 1930. Bulloch. W. [Obituary] J. Path. Bact., Lond., 1931, 34: 125-9.—Obituary. Brit. M. J., 1930, 2: 801. Also Lancet, Lond., 1930, 2: 995. HAFFKINIZATION. See Plague, Immunization. HAFFNER, Felix, 1886- , & SCHULTZ, Otto Erich. Normdosen der gebrauchlichen Arzneimittel. 83p. 8? Stuttg., Wiss. Ver- lagsges., 1937. HAFFNER, Irene [geb. Kaufmann] 1895- *Der Wert der Blutzucker-Tageskurve fiir die Behandlung des Diabetes mellitus [Leipzig] I9p. 8? [Zeulenroda, A. Oberreuter, 1930] HAFFNER, Josef, 1911- *Heilungs- ergebnisse bei Hypernephromen und die Griinde fiir das Versagen der operativen Behandlung [Wurzburg] 19p. 8? Eisfeld, C. Beck, 1937. HAFFTER, Carl. *Die Wirkung von schwe- rem Wasser (D20) auf Herz, Muskel und Xerv [Basel] 38p. 8? Sirnach, Frei &c, 1936. HAFNER, Carl [Friedrich] 1903- *Die Rarefikation des Myoms [Wurzburg] 27p. 8? Schramberg, Gatzer & Hahn, 1932. HAFNER, Eugen August. *Zur Energetik der Aussalzung [Basel] p.259-69. 8? Berl., J. Springer, 1927. HAFNIUM. Hevesy, G. Das Element Hafnium. 49p. s? Berl., 1927. Urbain, G. Sur le celtium, element de nume>o atomique 72. C. rend. Acad, sc, 1923, 176: 469. HAFSTROEM, Torsten [Erivan] G[unnar]son, 1902- Takatas modifizierte Sublimatfuch- sinreaktion am Blutserum als Diagnostikum bei Leberkrankheiten. 160p. 8? Stockh., P. A. Xoi stedt & soner, 1935. Forms Suppl. 62, Acta med. scand. HAFT, Abraham Seamor. *Contribution au traitement de la sclerose en plaques par les ondes courtes. 20p. 8? Geneve, Imp. Commerce, 1935. HAFTER, Ernst, 1906- *Untersuchungen iiber den Mechanismus der retinalen Umstini- raung hinsichtlich einer Abhangigkeit vom vegetativen Nervensystem [Zurich] p.447-65. S? Berl.. J. Springer, 1932. Also Arch. ges. Physiol., 1932, 229: HAG AM AN, Francis Henry, 1896-1939. Obituary. J. Am. M. Ass., 1939, 113: 1655.—Shands. H. R. obituarv. Ann. Surg., 1940, 111: 906-8, portr. Also Tr. South. Surg. Ass. (1939) 1940, 52: 472-4. HAGAN, William Arthur. An outline of lectures on pathogenic bacteriology (veterinary) and immunity: Course 49; New York State Veterinary College at Cornell University, iv, 98 1. roy. 8? Rochester, N. Y., Flexigraph Co., 1936. HAGAROTOXIN. Karam Samaan. The isolation, properties and pharma- cological action of hagarotoxin. J. Egypt. M. Ass., 1935, 18: 17-31. HAGE. See Emmerich & Hage. Winke fiir die Entnahme und Einsendung von Material zur bakteriologischen, serologischen und histologischen Untersuchung [&c] 45p. 8? Berl., 1921. HAGE, Gunther, 1912- *Ueber zwei Fade von Thoraxmissbildung [Jena] 42p. 21cm. Weida, Thomas & Hubert, 1938. HAGE, Herbert, 1912- *Ueber tabische Arthropathie [Miinchen] 20p. 8? Speyer, Pilger, 1938. HAGE, Joseph, 1900- *Les vomisse- ments incoercibles de la grossesse sont-ils toujours d'origine pithiatique? importance de la psy- chotherapie. 91p. 8? Par., Jouve & cie, 1928. HAGEDOORN, Arend. *Beitrag zur Ent- wicklungsgeschichte des Auges [Amsterdam] 3 p. 1. 119p. 8? Munch., J. F. Bergmann, 1930. Also Arch. Augenh., 1929-30, 102: 33; 393. HAGEDORN, Annemarie, 1910- *Patho- genese und Therapie eines bemerkenswerten Falles von Tetanie [Berlin] 31p. 8? Erfurt, G. A. Koenig, 1936. HAGEDORN, Elisabeth, 1903- *Unter- suchungen iiber den Einfluss der Geburt und gynakologischer Operationen auf die Blase [Freiburg i. B.] 31p. 8? Aachen [n. pub.] 1929. HAGEDORN, Hans Christian, 1888- Unders0gelser vedr0rende blodsukkerregulationen hos mennesket; med saerligt henblik paa de kroniske glycosuriers differentialdiagnose [Re- search on blood sugar regulation in man, with special reference to the differential diagnosis of chronic glycosuria] 64p. 8? Kbh. [&c] [J. J0rgensen & co.] 1921. For portrait see Acta med. scand., 1938, 96: Suppl. 90, front. HAGEDORN, Heinrich Paul, 1913- *Untersuchung der Zahn- und Mundverhaltnisse der Schulen der Stadt Warendorf; Kindergarten, Volksschulen, hohere Schulen und Berufsschule [Munster] 24p. 21cm. Warendorf i. Westf.. K. Darpe, 1937. HAGEDORN, Hermann, 1882- Leonard Wood; a biography. 2v. 436p.; 524p 12 nl S? N. Y., Harper & bros, 1931 HAGEDORN, Karl, 1901- *Ueber einen Fall aleukamisi her Myelose mit Osteosklerose und einer alten Gicht; Beitrag zur Frage der aleukamischen Myelose, ihren Beziehungen zur perniziosen Anamie und zur Osteosklerose und des Problems Gicht und Leukamie [Bonn] HAGEDORN 17 HAGEN p.124-49. 8? Berl., J. Springer, 1926. Also Zschr. klin. Med., 1926, 104: HAGEK, Thaddeus, fl. 1580. Aphorismorum metoposcopicorum libellus. 2. ed. 79p. 24? Frankfurt, heirs of And. Wechel, 1584. HAGEL, Wigbert, 1909- *Beitrag zur Klinik des Morbus Banti. 24p. 8? Koln, J. Borowsky, 1936. HAGELBERG, Heinz, 1902- *Indika- tionen und Erfolge der Rontgenkastration [Kiel] 22p. 8? Schwerin (Mecklb.) W. Sand- meyer, 1930. HAGELSTAM, Jarl, 1860-1936. Fabritius, H. Nekrolog. Acta psychiat. neur., Kbh., 1936, 11: 1-4, portr.—Marcus, H. [Obituary] Hygiea, Stockh., 1936, 98: 33-43, portr.—Qvarnstrom, E. Obituary. Fin. lak. sail, hand., 1936, 79: 99-108. HAGEMANN, Fritz Willy. *Ueber Sackniere, perinephritische und intranephritische subkap- sulare Zysten bei den Haustieren [Bern] 25p. roy. 8? Berl., G. Reimer, 1910. Also Virchows Arch., 1910, 202: HAGEMANN, Gerhard, 1913- *Kompli- kationen nach Totalamputation der Mamma bei Carcinom [Berlin] 19p. 22cm. Hamb., A. Preilipper, 1937. HAGEMANN, Heinrich, 1908- *Zur Behandlung der typischen Radiusfraktur [Leip- zig] lOp. 8? Zeulenroda, A. Oberreuter, 1935. HAGEMANN, Oscar, 1862-1926. Pfeiffer, G., & Ohl, R. Nekrolog. Zschr. Veterinark., 1926, 38: 54-6. For portrait, photograph, see collection in library. HAGEMANN, Paul, 1908- *Mundunter- suchungen bei der Schuljugend der Stadt Pader- born, unter Beriicksichtigung der sozialen Ver- haltnisse [Munchen] 18p. 8? Bottrop, W. Postberg, 1935. HAGEMANN, Walter, 1908- *Ueber essentielle hypochrome Anaemie. 35p. 8°. Rostock, Winterberg, 1933. HAGEMANN, Wilhelm, 1908- *Laminek- tomie bei Wirbeltumoren [Kiel] 37p. 21cm. Wurzb., K. Triltsch, 1936. HAGEMEIER, Franziska, 1896- *Ueber das Molekulargewicht des Bakterienfarbstoffs Pyocyanin [Berlin] 16p. 8? Greifswald, E. Panzig & Co., 1933. HAGEMEISTER, Otto [Heinrich Erich] 1902- *In welchen Fallen und zu welchem Zeit- punkte soil die Transplantation von Mundschleim- haut bei den schweren Veriitzungen des Augapfels zur Ausfiihrung kommen? [Leipzig] 20p. 8? [Zeulenroda, A. Oberreuter] 1930. HAGEN, Adolf, 1910- *Ueber die Ge- fahren der Myelographie mit aufsteigendem Jodol [Freiburg i. B.] 14p. 23cm. Murnau Obb., Fiirst, 1935. HAGEN, Christian, 1903- *Vorzeitige Placentarlosung bei normalem Sitz [Berlin] 24p. 8? Jena, G. Neuenhahn, 1932. HAGEN, Franz, 1900- *Ueber die thera- peutischen Bestrebungen bei der Encephalitis epidemica. 26p. 8? [Bonn, n. pub.] 1926. HAGEN, Friedrich von, 1911- *Die wichtigsten Endokrinen des Flussaals; Thyreo- idea, Thymus und Hypophyse im Lebenszyklus des Flussaals (Anguilla vulgaris) nebst einigen Untersuchungen iiber das chromophile und chromophobe Kolloid der Thyreoidea [Bonn] p.467-538. pi. 8? Naumb. (Saale) Lippert & Co., 1936. Also Zool. Jahrb., Abt. Anat., 1936, 61: HAGEN, Fritz Bessel. See Kupffer, Carl, & Hagen, Fritz Bessel. Ueber den Schadel Kants [&c] 30p. 12? Konigsb., 1924. HAGEN, Josef, 1908- *Genital-Sarkome von 1912-32 an der Universitats-Frauenklinik zu Bonn. 82p. 8? Bonn, H. Schonershoven, 1934. HAGEN, Karl, 1901- *Die operative Therapie des Morbus Basedow an der chirur- gischen Universitatsklinik Heidelberg in den Jahren 1900-26 und ihre Ergebnisse [Heidel- berg] 71p. 8? Heppenheim, G. Otto, 1928. HAGEN, Konrad, 1910- *Ergebnisse in der Behandlung der Prostatahypertrophie in der chirurgischen Klinik Bonn. 39p. 8? [Bonn, n. pub.] 1935. HAGEN, Otto 1908- *Carcinoma cervicis et uteri bei chronischer Gonorrhoe cervicis uteri. 19p. 22cm. Giessen, J. Christ, 1936. HAGEN, Sigurd, 1885-1938. Den ser0se post- operative chorioidalavl0sning og dens patogenese en klinisk unders0kelse [Serous postoperative detachment of the choroid; its pathogenesis and clinical investigation] 155p. 8? Bergen, J. Griegs, 1920. For biography see Acta ophth., Kbh., 1938, 16: 185-7, portr. (H. Lystad) Also Norsk, mag. laegevid., 1938, 99: 653, portr. (R. Gording) HAGENAUER, Julius, 1903- *Die Patho- genese einer seltenen Herzmissbildung (Cor triatriatum) [Frankfurt a. M.] p.332-56. 8? Miinch., J. F. Bergmann, 1931. Also Frankf. Zschr. Path., 1931, 41: HAGENBUCH, Kurt, 1912- *Das Sprung- gelenk des Rindes; Bau- und Bewegungsart [Munchen] 57p. 21cm. Quakenbriick, R. Kleinert, 1938. HAGENBUCH, Martha. *Beitrag zur Kennt- nis der Strumitis [Basel] 20p. 8? Jena, G. Fischer, 1921. Also Mitt. Grenzgeb. Med. Chir., 1921, 33: HAGENBUSCH, Benno, 1906- *Unter- suchung iiber die Zahl der Dentinkanalchen. p.513-18. 8? Munch, [n. pub.] 1931. Also Deut. Mschr. Zahnh., 1931 49: HAGENBUT, Janus, 1500-58. De convi- viorum veterum Graecorum, et hoc tempore Germanorum ritibus, moribus ac sermonibus. 198p. 16? Basel, J. Oporinus, 1548. --- De amoris praestantia, et de Platonis ac Xenophontis dissensione libellus. p.49-146. 16? Basel, 1548. In his De conviviorum veterum. Basel, 1548. ---- Xenophontis philosophi Atheniensis symposium, p. 147-98. 16? Basel, 1548. In his De conviviorum veterum. Basel, 1548. HAGENJOST, Paul, 1906- *Ueber die Branchiome (Mischgeschwulste der Speichel- driisen) mit eigenen Fallen [Heidelberg] 15p. 8? Griindstadt, E. Sommer, 1934. HAGENOW, Willi, 1908- *Ueber einen Fall von diffuser, chronischer Bronchiolitis beim Pferd; ein Beitrag zur Pathogenese der Dampfig- keit. 24p. 8? Lpz., A. Edelmann, 1932. HAGENS, Elmer William, 1869- See Brown, E. V. L., Bothman, Louis [et al.] The 1934 year book of the eve, ear, nose and throat. 621p. 12? Chic, 1935. Also Brown, E. V. L„ Shambaugh, George E. [et al.] The 1935 year book of the eye, ear, nose and throat. 638p. 12? Chic. [1935] Also Botham, L., Crowe, S. J., & Hagens, E. W., eds. The 1940 year book of the eye, ear, nose and throat. 658p. 18J^cm. Chic, 1940. HAGER, Benjamin Harry, 1892- Infec- tions of the bladder, p.69-125. illust. pi. 8? Phila., Lea & Febiger, 1936. In Modern urol. (Cabot, H.) 3. ed., Phila., 1936, 2: HAGER, Franz, 1898- *Zur Pathologie der Kleinhirncysten [Munchen] 16p. 8? Mainburg, C. Weinmayer, 1934. HAGER, Frithjof, 1909- *Der gegen- wartige Stand der Frage der Sterilisierung 227475—vol. 7, 4th series----2 HAGER IS HAGGARD Minderwertiger in Deutschland [Kiel] 35p. 8? Bochum, H. Poppinghaus o. H.-G., 1934. HAGER, (ierhard, 1902- *Untersu< hun- gen iiber die pharmakologische Beeinflussbarkeit tier menschlichen Nabelschnurgefasse. 30p. 8? Kiel, Schmidt & Klaunig, 1927. HAGER, Hans Hermann Julius, 1816-1897. Das Mikroskop und seine Anwendung; Handbuch der praktischen Mikroskopie und Anleitung zu mikroskopischen Untersuchungen. 13. Aufl. ix, 373p. 8? Berl., J. Springer, 1925. Also 14. Aufl. ix, 368p. 478 illust. 8? 1932. ---- Hagers Handbuch der pharmazeutischen Praxis fiir Apotheker, Aerzte, Drogisten und Medizinalbeamte. 2v. 1. Bd: (A-I) 2. Bd: (K-Z) xi, 1573p.; 2 p. 1. 1579p. 25cm. Berl., J. Springer, 1925-27. Also 2. berichtigter Neu- druck. Bd 1: [A-I] Bd 2: [K-Z] 2v. 1573p.; l.")79p. illust. 1938. For E. P. see 2. set. of Index-catalogue. For biography see Gallerie hervorrag. Ther. Pharmakogn. Gegenwart, Geneve, 1897, 5-7, portr. (W. H.) HAGER, Use, 1906- *Beitrag zur Dia- gnostik der Nierentumoren [Freiburg] 36p. 2 1. tab. 8? Berl., H. Heenemann, 1931. ---- The same 28p. tab. 8? Lpz., H.Korn- feld, 1931. Forms H. 423, v.38, Berl. Klin. HAGER, Karl, 1907- *Untersuchung iiber die Feststellung der richtigen Bisshohe bei langjahrig Zahnlosen. 16p. 8? Miinch. [n. pub.] 1934. HAGER, Lotte, 1901- *Ueber Rontgen- bestrahlung bei Periphlebitis retinae. 18p. 8? Tub., E. Gobel, 1930. HAGER, Oskar, 1909- *Beitrag zu der unter dem Namen Lingua geographica bekannten Zungenaffektion. 17p. 8? Miinch., Bayer. Dr., 1933. HAGER, Rudolf, 1912- *Die fieberhafte Fehlgeburt [Heidelberg] 18p. 22^cm. Phi- lippsb., J. Kruse & Sonne, 1937. HAGERSTOWN, Md. Incidence (The) of illness in a general population group; general results of a morbidity study from December 1, 1921, through March 31, 1924, in Hagerstown, Md. Pub. Health Rep., Wash., 1925, 40: 279-91. HAGERTY, John Francis, 1869-1937. Epstein, H. B. [Obituary] J.M. Soc N.Jersey, 1937, 34: 186. HAGERTY, Warren. *Addison's anemia [S. Joseph's Hosp.] 12p. 4? S. Paul, Minne- sota, 1927-28. Type written. HAGES, Lothar, 1906- *Zur Charakteri- stik der halluzinatorischen Vorgange beim Delirium tremens. 29p. 8? Bonn [n. pub.] 1932. HAGESTEDT, Dietrich, 1910- *Der Biirsteffekt am marginalen Parodontium [Got- tingen] 17p. 8? Bottrop, W. Postberg, 1934. HAGGAG, Ahmed Zaki, 1898- *Ueber drei Falle von Kollumkarzinom kompliziert mit Schwangerschaft [Breslau] 24p. 8? Charlot- tenb., Gebr. Hoffmann, 1926. HAGGAR, Norman James, 1915-40. Obituary. Lancet, Lond., 1940, 1: 1101, portr. HAGGARD, Howard Wilcox, 1891- What you should know about health and disease; with an introduction by Yandell Henderson xiii 538p. 74 pi. 8? X. Y., Harper & bros, 1928. ' ---- Devils, drugs, and doctors; the story of the science of healing from medicine-man to doctor. xxii, 405 [l]p. 16 pi. 8? N. Y., Harper & bros, 1929. ---- The lame, the halt, and the blind; the vital r61e of medicine in the history of civiliza- tion, xxiv, 420p. 4 pi. 200 illust. 8? N. Y., Harper & bros, 1932. ---- Mystery, magic, and medicine; the rise of medicine from superstition to science. 192p. illust. portrs. 12? Garden City, N. Y., Doubleday, Doran & co., 1933. ---- The doctor in history. xiii, 408p. illust. 8? N. Haven, Yale Univ. Press, 1934. ---- Staying young beyond your years. diagr. 16? N. Y., Funk & Wagnalls vi, 89p [1937] illust. Man and his body, xiii, 594p. pi. tab. 8? N. Y., Harper [1938] ---- The science of health and disease; a textbook of physiology and hygiene. Rev. ed. xiii, 594p. illust. pi. diagr. 22cm. N. Y., Harper & brothers [1938] See also Henderson, Yandell, & Haggard, H. W. Noxious gases [&c] 220p. 8? N. Y., 1927. ----& FRY, Clements Collard. The anatomy of personality, xi p. 2 1. 357p. illust. pi. 8? N. Y., Harper & bros, 1936. HAGGARD, Howard Wilcox, & GREENBERG, Leon Arnold. Diet and physical efficiency; the influence of frequency of meals upon physical efficiency and industrial productivity, x, 180p. illust. diagrs. 8? N. Haven, Yale Univ. Press, 1935. HAGGARD, William David, 1826-1901. Davis, J. D. S. Master Surgeons of America. Surg. Gyn Obst., 1929, 48: 569-72, portr. HAGGARD, William David, 1872-1940. Sur- gery, queen of the arts and other papers and addresses, x, 389p. illust. pi. 8? Phila. W. B. Saunders Co., 1935. For biography see Ann. Surg., 1940, 112: 1129-33, portr. (H. A. Royster) Also Bull. Am. Coll. Surgeons, 1940, 25: 111 (J. M. Mason & A. Ochsner) Also J. Am. M. Ass., 1940, 114: 428, portr. Also Mississippi Doctor, 1939-40, 17: 517. Also Proc. Interst. Postgrad. M. Ass. N. America (1940) 1941, 149 (L. F. Barker) Also South. Surgeon, 1940, 9: 199-204 portr. (F. K. Boland) Also Tr. Am. Surg. Ass., 1940 58: 703-7, portr. (H. A. Royster) See also Leathers, W. S. A tribute to Dr W. D. Haggard. Diplomate, 1940, 12: 195-7.—Testimonial dinner in honor of Dr William David Haggard. J. Tennessee M. Ass., 1933 26- 7-19, portr. HAGGENMILLER, Kurt, 1908 *Ueber die Wirkung der Dampfe des Amylacetats. 23p. 8? Wiirzb. [n. pub.] 1932. HAGGENMILLER, Siegfried, 1905- *Nimmt die Sterblichkeit wegen Appendicitis trotz operativer Hilfe zu? [Wiirzburg] 16p 8° Kallmiinz, M. Lassleben, 1933. HAGGERTY, Helen Ruth, 1903- Cer- tain factors in the professional education of women teachers of physical education [Colum- 1938 ^^ 88P' 23Cm' N" Ym Colurabia Univ-> HAGHSKI, J. See Slanetz, L W., & Haghski, J. Methods for the diag- nosis and control of bovine mastitis. 14p. 8° Durham 1939 HAGIWARA, Take, 1873-1935. JObituary] Internat. Nurs. Rev., Geneve, 1936, 10: 237, HAGLER, Elmer Ellsworth, 1863-1937 Obituary. Tr. Am. Acad. Ophth. Otolar., 1938, 424. HAGLUND, Sims Emil Patrik, 1870-1937 ig Editor of Acta orthopaedic* scandinavica. Kbh.! v.l. For biography see Acta orthop. scand 1937 s- „ ■•■ ol803 il *%STne)^° J; B2nS„Surg_., 1938, 20:'sil! portr. Also Zschr. Orthop (H. Nilsonne) 1937-38, 67: 209-11 portr. HAGMAIER Werner, 1910- operattve Komplikationen bei kyphoskoliotischen Post- HAGMAIER 19 HAHN Patientinnen. 19p. 28y2cm. [Heidelb.] W. Hagmaier, 1937. HAGMAN Balancer Co. [Minneapolis, Minn.] Simplicity and accuracy in articulation. 32p. illust. 12? [Minneapolis, 1935] HAGMANN, Josef, 1874- *Ueber ab- norm lange Retention abgestorbener Friichte im Uterus (missed labour) [Tubingen] 26p 8? Berl., G. Karger, 1903. Obituary. Med. Ann. District of Columbia, 1940, 9: 289, portr. Also J. Washington Acad. Sc, 1940, 30: 539. HAGNER, Werner [Hugo Karl] 1913- *Primare Wundversorgung im Felde [Berlin] 17p. 21cm. Konigsb. (Pr.) O. Schulz, 1938. HAGNEY, Frederick W., 1868-1939. [Obituary] Abstr. Proc. Ass. Life Insur. M. Dir. America, 1939, 26: 306. HAGOOD, Johnson. The services of supply; a memoir of the Great War. xvii, front. 403p. 8? Bost., H. Mifflin Co., 1927. HAGUE (The) See '&-Gravenhage. HAGUENAU, J[acques] Les compressions progressives de la moelle. vi, 327p. illust. pi. 12? Par., N. Maloine, 1932. ---- Le liquide cephalo-rachidien. p.247- 316. 8? Par., 1935. In Traits physiol. norm. path. (Roger, G. H., & Binet, L.) Par., 1935, 10: HAGUENAUER, Jeanne, 1911- *Le pneumothorax spontane; complication tardive des pleuro-pneumopathies aigues chez l'enfant. 80p. 25^cm. Par., Vigot freres, 1939. HAGUENAUER-BRUM, Tauba. *Der Ein- fluss des Weltkrieges auf die Geburtenzahl und die Sauglingssterblichkeit (Auszug) 7p. 8? Zur., J. J. Meier, 1924. HAGUIER, Paul, 1908- *Du traitement actuel des grosses hydronephroses. 91p. pi. 24cm. Par., E. Desfosses, 1938. HAHN, Alfred Andre, 1900- *La biblio- theque de la Faculte de M6decine de Paris; apercu historique de son developpement et de son fonctionnement dans ses rapports avec revolution des sciences medicales et biologiques suivi d'un index complementaire de bibliographie medicale. 250p. 8? Par., Le Francois, 1929. ---- The same. 250p. illust. 8? Par., Libr. Le Frangois, 1929. HAHN, Amandus, 1889- Grundriss der Biochemie fiir Studierende. 2. Aufl. viii, 260p. 12 illust. 8? Stuttg., F. Enke, 1932. HAHN, Carl, 1906- *Das Resorptions- vermogen der normalen menschlichen Haut fiir Borsaure [Marburg] 35p. 8? Hersfeld, L. Funks, 1933. HAHN, Charlotte [Sophie] 1899- *Bronze- dtabetes mit besonderer Beriicksichtigung seiner Erscheinungsformen im Bereiche der Mund- hohle [Leipzig] 28p. 8? [Zeulenroda, A. Oberreuter] 1922. HAHN, Eduard, 1856- Honigsheim, P. Eduard Hahn und seine Stellung in der Geschichte der Ethnologie und Soziologie. Anthropos, Mod- ling, 1929, 24: 587-612. HAHN, Emmy, 1901- *Ueber Splenome. 13p. 8? [Miinch., n. pub.] 1928. HAHN, Erhard, 1907- *Die Wasser- stoffionenkonzentration des Speichels unter nor- malen und pathologischen Verhaltnissen mit besonderer Beriicksichtigung der Sauretherapie [Munchen] 29p. 8? Borna, It. Noske, 1934. HAHN, Ernst, 1899- *Die Mamma cystica und ihre Vorstufen bei jungen Frauen. p.531-64. 8? Berl., J. Springer, 1926. Also Virchows Arch., 1926, 262: HAHN, Georg, 1909- *Kritisch kasui- stische Bemerkungen iiber Kunstfehler in der Zahnheilkunde und deren forensische Beur- teilung. 48p. 8? Munch, [n. pub.] 1933. HAHN [Gerhard Heinrich] Wilhelm, 1912- *Leberveranderungen bei sensibilisierten Tieren [Tubingen] 16p. 8? Diisseld., G. H. Nolte, 1938. HAHN, Gunther von, 1908- *Amnio- tische Abschniirungen [Heidelberg] 18p. 8? Wiirzb.-Aumuhle, K. Triltsch, 1938. HAHN, Hans, 1909- *Ueber die Addi- tion von Aether an Formaldehyd bei der Be- lichtung. 47p. 8? Erlangen, R. Windsheimer, 1937. HAHN, Hans Dietrich, 1911- *Ueber Entstehung und Haufigkeit des dentalen Kiefer- hohlenempyems. 19p. 8? Munch., C. Wolf & Sohn, 1934. HAHN, Heinrich, 1900- *Das Verhalten der Wassermann-Reaktion bei florider Lues II durch antiluetische Behandlung. 20p. 8? Miinch., Kastner & Callwey, 1930. HAHN, Heinz, 1897- *Ueber das Xan- thom. 24p. 8? [Lpz., n. pub.] 1923. HAHN, Helene, 1908- *Zur Strahlen- behandlung maligner Tumoren von Hals und Nase. 37p. 8? Konigsb. i. Pr., J. Raabe, 1933. HAHN, Helmuth. Neue Methoden zur Untersuchung des Temperatursinnes. p. 919-94. 8? Berl., 1937. In Handb. biol. Arbeitsmeth. (Abderhalden, E.) Berl., 1937, Abt. 5. T. 7, 2. Halfte. HAHN, Hermann, 1892- *Beitrag zur Symptomatologie und Epidemiologie der akuten epidemischen Kinderlahmung mit besonderer Beriicksichtigung einer kleinen unterfrankischen Epidemie vom Juli 1921 bis inklusive Juli 1922. 104p. 2 pi. 8? Wiirzb., C. J. Becker, 1927. HAHN, Johann Sigmund. Die wunderbare Heilkraft des frischen Wassers bei dessen inner- lichem und ausserlichem Gebrauche; durch die Erfahrung bestatigt. 7. Aufl. viii, 251p. 18y2cm. Lpz., Kriiger & Co. [1938] HAHN, Josef, 1906- *Ueber die Kraft der menschlichen Zehen. 19p. 21cm. Bresl., E. Jakubik, 1937. HAHN, Josef, 1911- *Ueber endogene Gonorrhoe am Auge. 15p. 8? Frankf. a. M., J. Gebhardt, 1935. HAHN [Karl Ludwig] Werner, 1910- *Zur Klinik der utero-placentaren Apoplexie. 31p. 23cm. Lpz., A. Edelmann, 1937. HAHN, Karla Pauline, 1894-1939. Obituary. Bull. Acad. M. Cleveland. 1939, 23: No. 7, 8. HAHN, Kurt, 1902- *Ueber Hydrops foetus universalis congenitus [Munchen] 21p. 3 1. 8? Borna, R. Noske, 1927. HAHN, Kurt, 1906- *Beitrag zur Frage der Avertin-Todesfalle [Breslau] 48p. 8? Charlottenb., Gebr. Hoffmann, 1930. HAHN, Lucie Berthe, 1906- *L'idio- phagSdenisme de Paul Chevallier (phagedenisme g6om6trique de Brocq et Clement Simon) son origine staphylococcique et sa guerison par la vaccination spe^cinque. 119p. 8? Par., G. Doin & Co., 1934. HAHN, Ludwig, 1909- *Beitrage zur Erblichkeit des Carcinoms. 29p. 8? Wiirzb., Rita Verb, 1933. HAHN, Margarete, 1901- *Beitrage zur Osteomyelitis der Wirbelsaule. 29p. 8? Jena, G. Neuenhahn, 1928. HAHN 20 HAHNEMANN HAHN, Margarete, 1905- *Zur Frage tiefsitzender Stenosen der absteigenden Brust- aorta. 38p. S? Berl. [n. pub.] 1933. HAHN, Martha, 1911- *Die Parulis und ihre Behandlung. 32p. 22cm. Marb., H. Bauer, 1«.»36. HAHN, Martin, 1865-1934. Heymann. B. Nekrolog. Med. Welt, 1934, 8: 1713 — Nekrolog. Miinch. med. Wschr., 1934, 81:1788. Also Zschr. Hyg., 1934, 116: H. 5, front.—Schiitz. Nekrolog. Deut. med. Wschr., 1935. 61 : 69. For ponrait, photograph, see collection in library. HAHN, Oskar, 1906- *Beitrag zur Be- handlung der Pyometra des Rindes [Giessen] 36p. 8? Wurzb., K. Triltsch, 1935. HAHN, Otto, 1879- Applied radiochem- istry. xi, 278p. illust. portr. diagrs. 8? Ithaca, N. Y., Cornell Univ. Press, 1936. For portrait see Umschau, 1939, 43: 210. HAHN, Otto, 1887- Die Chirurgie des vegetativen Nervensystems. ix, 264p. roy. 8? Lpz., J. A. Barth, 1925. HAHN, Paul Johannes, 1909- *Zur Frage der Narcylenbetaubung. 79p. 21cm. Wiirzb., Gebr. Memminger, 1938. HAHN, Robert 1909- *Die Erfolge der operativen Therapie bei sogenannter cystischer Eierstockdegeneration. 24p. 22) >cm. Heidelb., Brausdr., 1936. HAHN, Rudolf, 1863-1934. Rille, J. H. Nekrolog. Derm. Wschr., 1934, 98: 1441. HAHN, Rudolf, 1908- *Ueber Hista- coniontophorese. 23p. 23cm. Lpz., A. Edel- mann, 1936. HAHN, Rudolf, 1909- *Krankhafte Schadigungen durch Pressluftwerkzeuge [Mun- ster] 31p. 8? Bochum, H. Poppinghaus, 1934. HAHN [Waldemar Paul] Erwin, 1907- *Traumatisch bedingte Aneurysmen der Arteria temporalis. 24p. 8? Konigsb. i. Pr., J. Raabe, 1931. HAHN, Waldemar [Paul Thomas Elisardo] 1905- *Untersuchungen iiber Mundwasser und Silargetten. 23p. 8? Lpz., A. Kreutzer, 1935. HAHN, Walter, 1907- *Die Behandlung des Kropfes. 24p. 8? Berl., M. Schneller, 1932. HAHN, Walter, 1908- *Eine Total- nekrose des Unterkiefers im Kindesalter; ihre Ursache und deren forensische Bedeutung [Frankfurt] 17p. 8? Stuttg., K. Daxer, 1933. HAHN, Wilhelm. Streifziige durch Sowjet- russland; eigene Erlebnisse und Erfahrungen aus dem Lande der Bolschewiken. 94p. 8? Wien, M. Perles, 1921. HAHNE, Heinrich, 1903- *Ueber die desinfizierende und faulnishemmende Wirkung einiger Mundpflegemittel. 45p. 8? Miinst., C. J. Fahle [1931] HAHNE, Use, 1912- *Ueber den Einfluss der vorzeitigen, zeitigen und spaten Extraktion der 6-Jahrmolaren auf die Zahnstellung als Ursache von Artikulationsstorungen und Zahn- lockerung. 40p. 8° Bonn, A. Brand, 1935. HAHNE, Karl Wilhelm, 1902- *Beitrage zu dem Kapitel: Die Bedeutung der Blutgruppen und Tastfiguren in Vaterschaftsprozessen. iv, 60p. 8? Bonn, Carthaus, 1929. HAHNEMANN, Christian Friedrich Samuel, 1755-1843. Chronic diseases; their peculiar nature and their homoeopathic cure (theoretical part only in this volume) transl. from the 2. enlarged German ed. of 1835, by Prof. Louis H. Tafel. 269p. 8? Phila., Boericke & Tafel, 1904. See also Croll-Picard, A. S. Hahnemann et l'homccopathie. 140p. 8? Par., 1933.—Diepgen, P. Hahnemann und die Homoopathie; historischer Beitrag zur Kritik der Lehre. 32p. 8? Freib. i. B., 1926.—Gumpert, M. Hahnemann; die aben- teuerlichen Schicksale eines arztlichen Rebellen und seiner Lehre der Homoopathie. 256p. 8? Berl. [1934]—Hobhouse, R. W. Life of Christian Samuel Hahnemann, founder of homoeopathy. 288p. 8? Lond. [1932]—Neumann, H. Fr. S. Hahnemann; der Medicus als Rebell. 78p. 12? Dresd. [1937]—Thouret, G. 'Samuel Hahnemann (1755-1843) sa vie; ses idees. 132p. 8? Par., 1932. Also Al aniversario del nacimiento de Hahnemann, 10 de abril de 1856; canto [by] La Redaction. Bandera homeop. Habana, 1856, 1: 224-30.—Beebe, H. M. Some observations of the lesser writings of Sami Hahnemann. J. Am. Inst. Homeop., 1936, 29: 593-603.—Benson, R. A. Letters of Samuel Hahnemann. Bull. N. York Acad. M., 1935, 11: 515- 21.—Bodman, F. The contribution to medicine made by Samuel Hahnemann. Janus, Leiden, 1933, 37: 247-56. ------ The contribution of Hahnemann to modern medicine. Med. Press & Circ, Lond., 1932, 184: 175.—Comet Fargas & Pinart. Alabanzas al fundador de la homeopatia, Samuel Hahnemann, por D. Amalio Gimeno. Rev. homeop., Barcel., 1908, 19: 233-5.—Cookinham, F. H. Life of Christian Samuel Hahne- mann by Rosa Waugh Hobhouse. Pacific Coast .1. Homoeop., 1933, 44: 483-9.—Giro, J. En honor de Hahnemann. Rev. homeop., Barcel., 1890, 1: 114-25.—Kaplowe, J. L. The genius of Hahnemann. Homoeop. Rec, 1938, 53: No. 11, 3- 14.—Kleiner, I. S. Hahnemann as a chemist. Sc. Month., 1938, 46: 450-4.—Lereboullet, P. Un vieux document sur Hahnemann et l'homoeopathie. Paris med., 1933, 89: annexe, 455.—Ross, T. D. Were Hahnemann alive today. Homoeop. Rec, 1939, 54: No. 5, 17-22.—Sarkar, B. K. Hahnemann the bacteriologist. Brit. Homoeop. J., 1939, 29: 306-16.—Tischner, R. Hahnemann und die Naturheilkraft. Hippokrates, Stuttg., 1933,4:260-0. ------ Hahnemann und Schelling. Sudhoffs Arch., 1937, 30: 98-112. ■—---- Hahnemanns geistesge- schichtliche Stellung. Wien. med. Wschr., 1940, 90: 555-7.— Weir, J. Samuel Hahnemann and his influence on medical thought. Proc. R. Soc. M. Lond., 1933, 26: Hist. Med., 24- 32.—Woodbury, D. C. Hahnemann as a psychiatrist. Hahne- man. Month., 1926, 51: 290-39. —---- Samuel Hahne- mann and his impress upon the world. Homoeop. Rec, 1926, 41: 481; 1931, 46: 235. ------■ Striking incidents in the life of Hahnemann. Pacific Coast J. Homoeop., 1934, 45: 354- 62. For biography see Rev. homeop., Mex., 1940, 5: No. 2, 7-32 (E. Boijsceauneau) HAHNEMANN, Gunther, 1912- *Ver- suche iiber die Wirkung von Weckmitteln am Zungen-Kieferreflex. 19p. 21cm. Freib. i. B., T. Kehrer, 1937. HAHNEMANN, Hermann, 1908- *Bei- trag zur Statistik der Psoriasis vulgaris [Er- langen] 28p. 8? Wiirzb., K. Roll, 1932. HAHNEMANN, Martin, 1909- *Beitrag zur Messung der Durchmesser der roten Blut- korperchen im Blute des Menschen [Jena] 32p. 8? Ochsenfurt, Fritz & Rappert, 1935. HAHNEMANNIAN (The) monthly. Phila., v.9-13, 1873-78; n. ser., v.l, 1879- HAHNER, Hans, 1902- *Eine Radialis- Arbeits-Schiene mit kleiner Handstutze am Hypothenar unter Erhaltung der Greiffahigkeit aller Finger. 16p. 8? Erlangen, K. Dores, 1933. HAHNER, Walter, 1908- *Ueber die Entwicklung des Gaumenzapfchens und die dabei auftretenden Storungen [Miinchen] 23p. 8? Waldenb.-Sachsen, E. Kastner, 1935. HAHNKE, Erwin, 1910- *Ist die Wasser- mannsche Reaktion bei Wochnerinnen in der Klinik lohnend? 27p. 8? Konigsb., J. Raabe, HAIBE, M. A. Pathogenie et traitement de 1 asthme bronchique. 42p. 8? Brux 1929 BelgfqTe! N°' 8' V'24, 1927""8' M§m- COUr°n' Acad' m6d" HAIBER, Luise, 1911- *Vergleichende Versuche uber den zeithchen Verlauf der resorp- tion Wirkung des Novokains und des Perkains bei verschiedener Applikation. 21p 2 ch 8° Tub., A. Becht, 1934. HAIDA. See Indian. HAIDOUDOFF 21 HAINES HAIDOUDOFF, Lazare, 1905- Con- tribution a l'etude du syndrome appendiculaire dans l'amibiase chronique latente. 55p. 8? Par., M. Vigne, 1930. HAIFA, Palestine. Department of Health, Malarial Research Unit. Annual report, 1923. HAIG, Alexander, 1853- Uric acid as a factor in the causation of disease. 5. ed. 2 1. [vii]-xvi, 846p. ch. tab. 8? Lond., J. & A. Churchill, 1900. HAIG, Earl Douglas Haigh, 1861-1928. Obituary. J. R. Army M. Corps, 1928, 50: 161, portr. HAIG, Harold Axel. An introduction to the histology of tumours, vii, 128p. illust. pi. 8? Lond., H. Kimpton, 1924. HAIK, Henri, 1902- *Etude de la coagulation du sang; procede de la seringue. 58p. pi. 8? Par., A. Legrand, 1930. HAIKE, Heinrich, 1864-1934. Stenger, P. Nekrolog. Zschr. Hals &c. Heilk., 1934, 37: 1. HAIL. Johannson, A. Bakterien im Hagel [Discussion] Miinch. med. Wschr., 1938, 85: 2032.— Scultetus, H. R. Kann Hagel aus kosmischem Eis entstehen? Zschr. ges. Naturwiss., 1938-39, 4: 271-81.—Vogl, A. Bakterien im Hagel. Munch. med. Wschr., 1938, 85: 1790. HAILE, Father Berard, 1874- Origin legend of the Navaho enemy way; text and trans- lation. 320p. illust. 2 pi. 25cm. N. Haven, Yale Univ. Press, 1938. Forms No. 17, Yale Univ. Pub. Anthrop. HAILER, Kurt, 1910- *Zur Frage der Behandlung der akuten, eitrigen Osteomyelitis [Munchen] 31p. 8? Bonn, H. Trapp, 1937. HAILMAN, David E. The prevalence of dis- abling illness among male and female workers and housewives, vii, 40p. 23cm. Wash., 1941. Forms No. 260, Pub. Health Bull. HAIM, Arthur. Bakteriolyse, Einsichten und Aussichten (mit besonderer Beriicksichtigung der D'Herelle- und Much-Lyse) 84p. 12? Lpz., C. Kabitzsch, 1925. HAIM, Emil, 1875-1937. Nekrolog. Biol, gen., Wien, 1937, 13: 419. HAIM ANN, Eduard, 1909- * Ueber die Beeinflussung der Diurese durch Schlafmittel. 16p. 22y2cm. Heidelb., H. Meister, 1936. HAIMERL, Franz Xaver, 1914- *Biolo- gische Betrachtung des Ruderns. 64p. 4 diagr. 8? Munch, [n. pub.] 1937. HAIMOVICI, H. Les embolies arterielles des membres. 336p. illust. roy. 8? Par., Masson [1937] See also Imbert, Raymond, Mosinger, Michel, & Haimovici, H. Les metrorragies menopausiques et post-menopausiques. 193p. 8? Par., 1936. HAIMOVICI, Joseph Leopold, 1897- *Amiel ou l'introspection morbide en litterature. 52p. 8? Par., L. Arnette, 1928. HAIMOVICI, Solo, 1905- *Sur un cas d'intoxication mortelle par le salicylate de soude. 64p. 8? Par., Jouve & cie, 1935. HAINAN. Burkwall, H. F. Diseases encountered among the Loi aboriginals in the Five Finger mountains of Hainan. Chin. M. J., 1937, 51: 93-6. HAINEBACH, Fritz Hermann, 1902- *Die versicherungsmedizinische Beurteilung der Herzklappenfehler [Freiburg i. B.] 25p. 8? [Tub.] Tiibinger Chronik, 1928. HAINER, Fritz, 1912- *Ueber Odontoide. 23p. 23cm. Marb., J. A. Koch, 1937. HAINES, Anna Jones, 1886- Health work in Soviet Russia, xviii, 177p. 12? N. Y., Vanguard Press, 1928. HAINES, Marcellus Clarence, 1902- *Surgical acidosis [Mercy & S. Mary's Hos- pitals] 12p. 4? Oshkosh, Wis. [n. pub.] 1927-28. HAINES, R. B. Microbiology in the preserva- tion of animal tissues, iv, 85p. illust. pi. tab. ch. 8? Lond., H. M. Stat. Off., 1937. Forms Spec. Rep. No. 45, Gr. Britain, Dep. Sc. & Indust. Res. HAINES, Willard D., 1862-1938. Ransohoff, L. J. [Obituary] Tr. West. Surg. Ass. (1938) 1939, 48: 532, portr. For portrait see Tr. West. Surg. Ass (1925) 1926, 35: frontispiece. HAINISS, Elemer, 1890- For Festschrift see Orvoskepz6s, 1934, 24: nov. kulonf. HAINKE, Luise, 1906- *Ueber das Ulcus ventriculi im Kindesalter und seine rontgenologische Darstellung. 16p. 8? Berl., F. Linke, 1935. HAINZ, Georg, 1911- *Ueber Versuche eine Schwangerschaft aus dem Urin auf chemi- schem Wege festzustellen [Munchen] 17p. 8? Bottrop, W. Postberg, 1937. HAIR. See also Axilla; Beard; Eyebrow; Eyelash; Fiber; Fur; Genital hair; Lanugo; Moustache; Scalp; also Haircutting; Hairdresser; Hair dye; Hair follicle; Hairlessness; Hair-plucking; Hair wash [and tonic] Hairwaving. Galewsky, E., Mayr, J. K., & Stein, R. O. Haare und Haarboden; Schweissdriisen; Talg- drusen. 468p. 8? Berl., 1932. Lochte, T. Atlas der menschlichen und tierischen Haare. 306p. 26}^cm. Lpz., 1938. O'Donovan, W. J. The hair; its care, dis- eases and treatment. 218p. 8? Phila., 1930. Savill, A. F. B. The hair and scalp; a clinical study (with a chapter on hirsuties) 288p. 8? Lond. [1935] Sperling, G. *Die Form der apokrinen Haardrusen des Menschen [Konigsberg] p.241- 52. 8? Lpz., 1935. Also Zschr. mikr. anat. Forsch., 1935, 38: Basler, A. Beitrage zur Phvsiologie der Korperhaare. Zschr. Biol., 1938-39, 99: 80-91.—Berg, C. The unconscious significance of hair. Internat. J. Psychoanal., Lond., 1936, 17: 73-88.—Courmont, R. de. Les cheveux. Aesculape, Par., 1935, 25: 276.—Danforth, C. H. Physiology of human hair. Physiol. Rev., 1939, 19: 94-111.—Da Settignano, D. La Marie-Madeleine repentante de Desiderio da Settignano. Aesculape, Par., 1936, 26: 25.—Fitgerald. C. P. Notes on the scalp and hair. Pedag. Semin., Worcester, 1914, 21: 329-35 — Lespinne, V. La physiologie de la secretion du poll. Bull. Acad. med. Belgique, 1929, 5. ser., 9: 681-700.—McFarland, J. A resurrection of pile; the Peter A. Browne collection of hair in the Mutter Museum. Tr. Coll. Physicians Philadelphia, 1939-40, 7: 278-96.—Riehl, G. Ueber Haare. Deut. Aerzte Ztg, 1933, 8: No. 355.—Rozprym, F. Eyebrows and eyelashes in man: their different forms, pigmentation and heredity. J. R. Anthrop. Inst. Gr. Britain, 1934, 64: 353-95.—Une etude de nuque et de chevelure d'apr^s Francois Boucher. Aesculape, Par., 1938, 28: 1. ---- Abnormity. See also Dermoid; Hairlessness; Nevus. Clouston, H. R. A hereditary ectodermal dystrophy. ( anad. M. Ass. J., 1929, 21: 18-31.— Jacobsen. A. W. Heredi- tary dyst rophy of the hair and nails. J. Am. M. Ass., 1928, 90: 686-9'—Mayer, W. D. Congenital dystrophy of the hair and nails. " .1. Michigan M. Soc, 1928, 27: 713-5.—Pastore, J. Disposizione anomala dei capelli della nuca. Riv. antrop., 1930-32, 29: 569-75.—Pierini, L., Torti, P., & Borda, J. M. Primera observation de esta rarisima distrofia pilar vista en el pais. Prensa med. argent., 1941,28: 521.—Triquiasis (De la) Diar. gen. cienc. med., Barcel., 1832, 8: 27-33.—Wagner, H. Makulaaffektion vergesellschaftet mit Haarabnormitat von Lanugotypus, beide vielleicht angeboren bei zwei Geschwistern. Schweiz. med. Wschr., 1935, 65: 1061. ---- Allergen. See under Allergy. HAIR 22 HAIR ---- animal. See also Fur; Wool. Avrin, W. *Ist die Untcrscheidung von Hasen- und Kaninchenhaaren durch Unter- suchung der Cuticula und der Marksubstanz moglich? p.289-312. 8? Gottingen, 1932. Also Deut. Zschr. gerichtl. Med., 1932, 20: Bodmeii, II. *Aeussere Unterscheidungs- merkmale, insbesondere solche des Haarkleides der schweizerischen Feld- und Alpenhasen (Lepus europaeus Pall, und Lepus varronis Miller) [Zurich] 106p. 8? Lpz., 1924. Also Zschr. indukt. Abstamm., 35: Darsonval, M. G. E. *Contribution a l'etude morphologique du poil du chien [Alfort] 79p. 8? Par., 1931. Broman, I. Ueber die ersten Entwii klungsstadien der Mahne der Giraffen und der Equidae. Anat. Anz., 1937-38, 85: 241-9.—Butcher, E. O. The hair cvcles in the albino rat. Anat. Rec, 1934-35, 61: 5-19, 2 pi.—Herre. W.. & Rabes, I. Studien an der Haut des Karakulschafes. Zschr. mikr. anat. Forsch., 1937, 42: 525-54.—Hofliger, H. Haarkleid und Haut des Wildschweines; Beitrag zur Anatomie von Sus scrofa L. und zum Domestikationsproblem. Zschr. ges. Anat., 1. Abt., 1931, 96: 551-623.—Huestis, R. R. Local differences in pelage characters of Peromvscus. J. Mammal., 1932, 13: 210-8.— Mogi, E. Untersuchungen iiber die Haardichtigkeit bei den Feten einiger Saugetierarten. Okajimas fol. anat., 1937, 15: Erganzbd, 255-63.—Miiller. C. Ueber den Feinbau des Siiugetierhaares und die Allwordensche Reaktion. Zschr. Zellforsch., 1939, 29: 1-43. ------ Ueber den Bau der koronalen Schiippchen des Siiugetierhaares. Zool. Anz., 1939, 126: 97-107.—Niedoba. T. Haarstrich-Probleme; Beitrag zur Vererbungs- und Konstitutionslehre, insbesondere Terato- genese und Zilchtungsbiologie. Wien. tierarztl. Mschr., 1929, 16: 697; 737. pi.—Reed. S. C. Determination of hair structure; the production of waved hair from genetically non-waved cells. J. Exp. Zool., 1938, 79: 347-51. Schneider, H. Die Haare und sonstigen Chitingebilde der Kohlraupe (Pieris brassicae L.) Zool. Anz., 1923, 56: 155-60.—Schultz, A. H. The density of hair in primates. Human Biol., 1931, 3: 303-21.—Stuart, L. S. The saprophytic digestion of heat-sterilized animal hair and keratose. J. Bact., Bait., 1937, 33: 97.—Troll-Obergfell, B. Ueber einige Besonderheiten der Haare des gemeinen See- hundes (Phoca vitulina L.) Anat. Anz., 1930, 69: 404-15.— Wildman, A. B. The hairs of the Monotremata, with special reference to their cuticular-scale pattern. Tr. R. Soc Edin- burgh, 1937-38, 59: 333-49, 7 pi.—Yoshio Abe. Histologische Untersuchungen des Sommcr- und Winterhaarkleides. J. Sc. Hiroshima Univ., 1930, 1: 1-32, 11 pi. ---- Anthropology. Oliver, E. *La pilosidad en el hornbre en relaci6n con la edad y la raza [Univ. Chile] 40p. 8? Concepci6n, 1934. Basler, A. Ueber die Wurzelfestigkeit der Kopfhaare bei Chinesen. Zschr. Morph. Anthrop., 1926-27, 26: 247-55. ------& Li, B. L. Weitere Untersuchungen iiber die Wurzel- festigkeit der Chinesenhaare. Ibid., 1928-29, 27: 131-4.__ Bernstein, M., & Robertson, S. Racial and sexual differences in hair weight. Am. J. Phys. Anthrop., 1927, 10: 379-85.__ Bloch, A. Sur quelques caracteres particuliers de la chevelure dans diverses races. Bull. Soc. anthrop. Paris, 1925, 7. ser 6- 153-60.—Gray, J. H. The hair tracts of the Australian 'ab- original. J. Anat., Lond., 1934-35, 69: 206-25, ch.—Kneberg, M. Hair weight as a racial criterion. Am. J. Phvs Anthron ' 1936, 21, 2: 279-86.—Kuiita. Y. Die Dichtigkeit der Korper- behaarung bei den japanischen Zwillingsfeten. Okajimas fol anat., 1938-39, 17: 85-120.—Minakov, P. [Hair and its anthropological aspect] Russ. antrop. J., 1900, 1: 83-94__ Nakano, Y. Ueber die Kopfhaare der For'mosa-Wilden Taiwan igakkai zasshi, 1930, 33.—Sailer, K. Untersuchungen an Haarproben der Senoi und Penning. Zschr. Morph. Anthron 1928-29, 27: 135-40.—Sarasin. F. Sur le changement de la chevelure chez les enfants des Mclanesiens et des negres afri- cains. Anthropologic, Par.. 19-'."), 35: 467-74.—Sokolowsky, A. Das Haarkleid des .Menschen in seinen Beziehungen zu d'erri der MenschcnalTen. Derm. Wschr., 1929, 88: 432-7.—Steg- gerda. M. Cross sections of human hair from four racial groups •1. Hered., 1940, 31: 471-0. ------ & Eckardt, R. B. Cross sections of human hair from four racial groups. Yearb Car- negie Inst. Washington (1939-40) 1940, 39: 228—Trotter, M. The hair of the Arabs of central Iraq. Am. J. Phys. Anthrop., 1936, 21: 423-8.------ A review of the classifications of hair. Ibid., 193s-39, 24: 105-26. ------ & Dawson, H. L. The hair of French Canadians. Ibid., 1934, 18: 443-56. Also repr.— Wood-Jones, F. The dorsal hair tracts of the Australian aborigine. J. Anat., Lond., 1934, 69: 91, pi. ---- Arrangement on body. Scheuer, O. F. Die Behaarung des Men- schen. 93p. 8? Lpz., 1933. Forms H. 17, Monogr. Frauenk. Bolk, L. On the course of hair-currents. Proc. Akad. Wet. Amsterdam, 1929, 32: pt 2, Sect. Sc, 1212-7.—Grun- baum, A. Die Kopfbehaarung des Mannes im hoheren Alter, ihre Beziehungen zu den Altersstufen und zur Konstitution. Zschr. ges. Anat., 2. Abt., 1928-29, 14: 487-92. -Jones, F. W. Tension lines, cleavage lines and hair tracts in man. J. Anat., Lond., 1940-41, 75: 248-50.—Kurokochi, T., & Mukaiyama, K. Ueber den Haarstrom des Gesichts bei jungon Japanern. J. Nippon Dent. Ass., 1933, 26: 40.—Lauterbach, C. E.. & Knight, J. B. Variation in whorl of the head hair. J. Hered., 1927, 18: 107-16.—Risak, K. Ueber den Einfluss der Milch- leiste auf das Haarkleid des Menschen. Zschr. ges. Anat., 2. Abt., 1929-30, 15: 434-43.—Routil, R. Ueber einige Be- obachtungen am menschlichen Haarkieide. Zschr. Morph. Anthrop., 1933, 32: 483-5, ch.—Schumacher, O. Haarfelder und Skelettsystem. Verb. Deut. path. Ges., 1935, 28: 315-20.- Skin lines and hair trends. Lancet, Lond., 1041, 1: 422.— Trotter, M. The form, size, and color of head hair in American whites. Am. J. Phys. Anthrop., 1930-31, 14: 433-45. Also repr.—Wood-Jones, F. The middorsal hair whorl of man. Ibid., 1927, 11: 89-95. ---- Bacteriology. Biehler, M. [Constant bacteriological flora of the hair of children] Pedjat. polska, 1936, 16: 325-31. Also Arch. med. enf., 1936, 39: 157-61. ---- Chemistry. Bagchi, K. N., Ganguly, H. D., & Sirdar, J. N. Lead-content of human hair. Ind. J. M. Res., 1939-40, 27: 777-91.— Block, W. D., & Lewis, H. B. The amino acid content of cow and chimpanzee hair. J. Biol. Chem., 1938, 125: 561-70. Also repr.—Brown, H., & Klauder, J. V. Sulphur content of hair and of nails in abnormal states; therapeutic value of hydrolyzed wool; hair. Arch. Derm. Syph., Chic, 1933, 27: 584-604.—Clay, R. C. Cook, K.. & Routh, J. I. Studies in the composition of human hair. J. Am. Chem. Soc, 1940, 62: 2709.—Composition (The) of human hair. Nature, Lond., 1941, 147: 30.—Ikeuchi, K. Beitrage zur Biochemie der Haare; iiber den Kalziumgehalt der Haare. J. Orient. M., Dairen, 1927, 7: 1.—Jordan-Lloyd, D., & Marriott, R. H. The distribution of sulphur in goat hair. Biochem. J., Lond., 1933, 27: 911-4.—Marchionini, A. Physikalisch-chemische Untersuchungen an gesunden und kranken Haaren. Derm. Zschr., 1936-37, 74: 362. ------ & Weiss, L. Weitere physikalisch-chemische Untersuchungen an menschlichen Haaren unter physiologischen Bedingungen. Derm. Wschr., 1938, 106: 661-6.—Rimington, C. The relation between cystine yield and total sulphur in various animal hairs. Bio- chem. J., Lond., 1929, 23: 726-9.—Stary. Z., & Richter, R. Das Leukokeratin und die Chromoproteide des Menschen- haares. Zschr. physiol. Chem., 1938, 253: 159-69.—Tadokoro, T., & Ugami, H. On the cystin and cystein contents of human hair. J. Biochem., Tokyo, 1930, 12: 187-93—Wuhrer, J. Ueber den normalen Arsengehalt des menschlichen Haares. Biochem. Zschr., 1937, 294: 401-6. ---- Clinical aspect. Heuschen [J.] J. [H.] *Ueber die Behaarung Geisteskranker. 23p. 8? Bonn, 1934. Epstein, S Die Beziehungen von Haar- und Hautfarbe S^nHautePithehom. Arch. Derm. Syph., Berl., 1931, 164: 304-9.—Kosiakoy, K. S. [Phosphorus of the hair in malignant tumors] Biull. eksp. biol. med., 1939, 7: 413-6.—Levinger, E. Die Bedeutung des Behaarungstypus bei der Entstehung von Erkrankungen des Nervensystems; ein Beitrag zur Frage der Beziehungen zwischen Sexualkonstitution und Krankheits- bereitschaft. Arch. Frauenk., 1928, 14: 29-50 —M L K Die Haardiagnose des Wunderdoktors Buchh'olz. Zschr! arztl. Fortbild., 1928 25: 606,-Risak, E. Das menschliche ™ m^n%\ Huuscshen Bedeutung. Wien. klin. Wschr., w2L !* ■• S7"xV~?ct,0Mer' H- Ueher Menstruation, Wehenschwache, Nachgeburtsperiode und Haarfarbe und ihre gegenseitigen Beziehungen. Zbl. Gyn., 1926, 50: 3268-74 — W.schnow.tzer E. Significance of the pilous system in in- ternal diseasesj Polska gaz. lek., 1938, 17: 341. ---- Color. See also Pigmentation. Friedenthal, H. Blondheit und Albinismus beig Menschen und Tieren. p.453-70. 8? [Sl] Anz., 1928, 5: 238-44.-Gardner B n^i^1" Anthrop. Colorimetric analysis of &X%* & .*!%££*&&£ HAIR 23 HAIR 1934, 19: 187-201, ch.—Hausman, L. A. The pigmentation of human head-hair. Am. Natur., 1927, 61: 545-54.—Nishi- zaki. S. Experimental study of coloration of fur of Mammalia; mutual relation between the colour of rabbit fur and the re- sistance against narcosis and hemorrhage. Jap. J. Obst., 1929, 12: 61.—Richter, R., & Stary, Z. Haarfarbe und Haarfarb- stoffe. Arch. Derm. Syph., Berl., 1938-39, 178: 373-80 — Schilling, L. LTntersuchungen zur Variabilitat der Meerschwein- chenhaare und ihrer Pigmente. Zschr. indukt. Abstamm., 1939, 76: 535-68.—Trotter, M. Classifications of hair color. Am. .1. Phys. Anthrop., 1939-40, 25: 237-60. Also repr — W. F. W. J. The adventure of the platinum blonde S. Barth. Hosp. J., Lond., 1933, 40: 168; 216.—Welde, E. Wesen und Bedeutung der menschlichen Haarfarben. Derm. Wschr., 1936, 102: 292-4. Also Konst. & Klinik, 1938, 1: 95-100.— Williams, L. L. B. Of colour of the hair. In his Minor med. mysteries, Lond., 1936, 50-7. ---- Color: Abnormities, and changes. See also Albinism; Canities; Hair dye; Vitiligo; also Vitamin B2. Brauer, A. Ueber Heterochromie der Haare. Derm. Zschr., 1930-31, 60: 438-44.—Cheatle, G. L. On the mental nerve area and its relation to the grcvness of hair. Brit. M. J., 1908, 2: 20, pi.—Emerson, G. A., & Evans, H. M. Growth and graving of rats with total filtrate factor and with panto- thenic acid. Proc Soc. Exp. Biol., N. Y., 1941, 46: 655-8 — Engelsmeier. W. Einfluss der Temperatur auf die Ausfarbung der Haare bei Kaninchen verschiedener Erbrassen. Zschr. indukt. Abstamm., 1937, 73: 601-16.—Ferrabouc, L. Sur la maladie jaune des cheveux blancs. Bull. Soc. fr. derm. syph., 1939, 46: 720-2.—Francois-Dainville, E. L'hemicanitie. Presse med., 1910, 18: 225.—Frohn, W. Ueber Anomalien der Haarfarbe. Derm. Zschr., 1938, 77: 4-26.—Gyorgy P., & Poling, C. E. Further experiments on nutritional achromo- trichia in rats and mice. Proc. Soc. Exp. Biol., N. Y., 1940, 45: 773-6. ------ & Subbarow, Y. Observations on the factor curative of nutritional achromotrichia. J. Biol. Chem., 1940, 132: 789. Also repr.—Jarnecke, H. Durch aussere Einfliisse hervorgerufene Haarverfarbungen. Derm. WTschr., 1938, 106: 212-6.—Lenartowicz [Nevus achromicus et heterochromia pilorum semilunaris] Przegl. derm., Warsz., 1939, 34: 63-5.—Lubnow, E. Die Wirkung der Rontgen- strahlen auf die Pigmentbildung im Kaninchenhaar. Zschr. indukt. Abstamm., 1939, 77: 516-32.—Nielsen, E., Oleson, J. J., & Elvehjem, C. A. Fractionation of the factor preventing nutritional achromotrichia. J. Biol. Chem., 1940, 133: 637. Also repr.—Oleson, J. J.. Elvehjem, C. A., & Hart. E. B. Nutritional achromotrichia. Proc. Soc. Exp. Biol., N. Y., 1939, 42: 283-5.—Pictet, A. Recherches sur l'heredite de la dilution et du blanchement du pelage dans le genre Cavia. Genetica, Gravenh., 1940, 22: 1-122.—Plummer, S. Student pedigree-studies; the P. family, with premature white hair. Eugen. News, 1937, 22: 108.—Rusu, V. [Effect of roentgen rays on the hair; case of postroentgen therapeutic depigmenta- tion] Romania med., 1937, 15: 248.—Schultz, W. Erzeugung des Winterschwarz; willkurliche Schwarzung gelber Haare. Arch. Entwmech., 1922, 51: 337-82, 2 pi.—Siemens, H. W. Ueber Haarbleichung, Melanotrichosis circumscripta und Naevus pigmentoso-pilosus des behaarten Kopfes. Derm. Zschr., 1932, 64: 35-43.—Verbunt, J. A. [Spotted discoloration of hair] Ned. tschr. geneesk., 1926, 70: pt 2, 2303.—Wirth, D. Eine eigenartige Anomalie des Haarpigmentes bei einem Pferd. Wien. tierarztl. Mschr., 1926, 13: 468-70. ---- Color: Heredity. Clark, F. H. Coat color in the meadow-vole; inheritance of cream coat-color in Microtus pennsylvanicus, with descriptions of several other color variations. J. Hered., 1938, 29: 265.— Engelsmeier, W. Nachweis der alternativen Modifikabilitat der Haarfarbung beim Russenkaninchen; ein Beitrag zur Theorie der quantitativen Wirkung der Gene. Zschr. indukt. Abstamm., 1934-35, 68: 361-416.—Fitch, L. Inheritance of a white forelock. J. Hered., 1937, 28: 413.—Nussey, A. M. White forelock, a new mutation. Lancet, Lond., 1938, 2: 947.— Reed, S. C. Determination of hair pigments; proof that expres- sion of the black-and-tan gene is dependent upon tissue organiza- tion. J. Exp. Zool., 1938, 79: 337-46.—Sailer, K. Erblicher Rutilismus in der Malayischen Inselwelt; mit allgemeinen Bemerkungen iiber den Erbgang der menschlichen Haarfarbe, Zschr. indukt. Abstamm., 1927, 45: 202-31. —----& Maroske, F. Ueber den Chemismus der menschlichen Haarfarben und seine Vererbung. Eugenik, Berl., 1931-32, 2: 110; 128 — Sundf0r, H. [A rare, hereditary case of pigmentary anomaly] Norsk mag. laegevid., 1938, 99: 1015-31. ---- Color: Pigment. Bunak, V. V. [Variations of pigment and their significance in variations of hair color] Biol. J., Moskva, 1937, 6: 589- 600.—Danneel, R. Pigmentstudien; das spektroskopische Verhalten der Haarpigmente. Zschr. vergl. Physiol., 1930, 12: 279-92. ------ Untersuchungen iiber die temperaturempfind- liche Haarpigmentbildung bei Russenkaninchen. Zschr. indukt. Abstamm., 1937, 73: 456-62.—Hausman, L. A. The pigment granules of human head hair; a comparative racial study. Am. J. Phys. Anthrop., 1928-29, 12: 273-83.—Jankowsky, W. Beitrag zur Frage der Haarpigmente. Zschr. Rassenphysiol., 1932, 5: 1; 111. ------ Der Zusammenhang zwischen der Farbe und dem Pigment des Haares. Verh. Ges. phys. Anthrop., 1935, 7: 2-4.—Neumann, P. Haarpigmentuntersuchungen an verschiedenen Farbrassen des Kaninchens. Biol. Zbl., 1937, 57: 522-50.—Reed, S. C. Determination of hair pigments. transplantation results in mice, rats and guinea pigs. J. Exp; Zool., 1938 79: 331-6.—Sailer, K., & Maroske, F. Chemische und genetische Untersuchungen an menschlichen Pigmenten, speciell demjenigen des Haares. Zschr. ges. Anat., 2. Abt., 1932-33, 17: 279-317, ch.—Schultz, W. Luftmelaninbildung bei Zimmertemperatur in SSugetieraugen und Haarwurzeln. Arch. Entwmech., 1930, 123: 132-52.—Takeuchi. K. Zur Kenntnis der Entstehung der Haarpigmente. Tr. Jap. Path. Soc, 1925, 15: 56. ------ Ueber die Bildung des Haar- pigmentes der Embryonalhaare des Menschen. Ibid., 1926, 16: 135.—Zwicky, H., & Almasy, F. Optische Untersuchungen iiber das Haarpigment. Biochem. Zschr., 1935, 281: 103-10. ---- Color, red. Maroske, F. *Untersuchungen iiber Zusam- menhange zwischen Rothaarigkeitund Charakter. 40p. 22^cm. Greifswald, 1937. Arnow, L. E. The acid-soluble pigment of red human hair Biochem. J., Lond., 1938, 32: 1281-4.—Conitzer, H. Zur Vererbung der Rothaarigkeit. Verh. Ges. phys. Anthrop., 1931, 5: 60-5. Also Zschr. Morph. Anthrop., 1931, 29: 83-147, 2 pi., ch., 5 tab.—Johnsson, J. W. S. Zur Geschichte des rothaari- gen Mamies, im Manuskript Ny k. S. 846 in der Koniglichen BibUothek zu Kopenhagen. Janus, Leyde, 1927, 31: 304-17, pi.—Michelson, N. Distribution of red hair according to age. Am. J. Phys. Anthrop., 1934, 18:407-13.—Ritter, R. Rothaa- rigkeit als rassenhygienisches Problem. Volk & Rasse, 1935, 10: 385-90.—Sailer, K. Ueber den Erbgang der Rothaarigkeit beim Menschen. Zschr. indukt. Abstamm., 1931, 59: 203-19. ---- Disease. See also subheadings; also Alopecia; Folli- culitis; Hair follicle; also names of primary diseases as Atrophoderma; Dermatitis; Epi- dermolysis; Granuloma fungoides, &c. Khorassani, N. *Les troubles du systeme pileux et les glandes endocrines. 103p. 24}icm. Par., 1938. Lawrence, E. The hair in health and disease; a new explanation of diseases of the hair, scalp, and skin, and of barbers' diseases in particular. 181p. 8? Lond., 1936. Levy-Frankel, A. Maladies des poils. p.345-406. 4? Par., 1933. In Traite derm. (Schulmann) 1933, 2: McCarthy, L. Diagnosis and treatment of diseases of the hair. 671p. 25cm. St Louis, 1940. Savill, A. F. B. The hair and scalp, a clinical study (with a chapter on hirsuties) 288p. 8? Lond. [1935] Stein, R. O. Die Krankheiten der Haare. p.847-922. 8? Berl., 1934. In Haut- u. Geschlechts.-Kr. (Arzt & Zieler) Berl., 1934, 3: ---- Haarkrankheiten und kosmetische Haut- leiden, mit besonderer Beriicksichtigung der Therapie. 218p. 8? Wien, 1935. Cajkovac, S. Ein Beitrag zur Frage der Schiidigung des Haarschaftes. Derm. Zschr., 1938, 77: 305-21.—Cronquist. C. [Diseases of the hair as a specialty] Sven. lak. tidn., 1931, 28: 1057-61.—Forman, L. Diseases of the hair. Guy's Hosp. Gaz., Lond., 1939, 53: 128-31.—Freund, L. Die Entwicklung der Behandlung der infektiosen Krankheiten des Haarbodens. Fortsch. Rontgenstrahl., 1938, 57: 376. Also Wien. med. Wschr 1938, 88: 61-4.—Goldsmith, W. N. Peculiar fracture of hairs. Proc. R. Soc M., Lond., 1934-35, 28: 1549.—Gordon, H. Diseases of the hair in adults. Med. Press & Cir., Lond., 1934 188: 421-5.—Kinnear, J. Uncommon diseases of the hair.' Ibid., 1938, 197: 12-6.—Knowles, F. C, Decker, H. B. [et al.] Pseudo-ectothrix; a filamentous change noted on the hair root in certain inflammations of the scalp. Arch. Derm. Syph., Chic, 1935, 31: 38-47— Kosugi, T., & Kim, Y. S. Zur Pathohistologie der Glatze der Kopfhaut und des Ergrauens der Kopfhaare. Tr. Soc path, jap., 1937, 27: 651-3.—Ludy, J. B. Hair and scalp; diseases. In Cyclop. Med. (Piersol- Bortz) Phila., 1939, 6: 906-21, pi.—Marchionini, A., & Draeseke, L. Physikalisch-chemisch nachweisbare Verande- rungen der Haare bei Haarkrankheiten und inneren Leiden. Derm. Wschr., 1938, 107: 917-22.—Miiller, R. W. The Nagelschmidt modification of the Kromayer quartz lamp in the treatment of diseases of the hair and scalp. Yearb. M. Ass. Gr. N. York, 1915, 78-80.—Pohl (Pincus) A. Ausgewahlte Typen von Haarkrankheiten. Zschr. arztl. Fortbild., 1925, 22: 385; passim.—Poulsen, A. [Oily and dry hair] Ugeskr. laeger, 1938 100: 442-7.—Remenovsky, F. Beitrag zur Haarpatho- logie' Wien. med. Wschr., 1933, 83: 755.—Rosentul, M. A. HAIR 24 HAIR .Mi-eases of the hair and their treatment] Feldsher, Moskva, 193s. No. 5, 46; No. 7, 42.- -Sahouraud. R. Opposition, chez I'homme et'chez la femme, de- elections du cuir chevelu le- plus communes a l'age mur. < Imiiue, Par., 1932, 27: 63. ------Maladies des poils. In Nouv. prat. derm. iDarier, Sabouraud [et al.]) Par., 1936, 7: 114-2s. Stein. R. O. Die Erkrankungen der Haare und Xrigel im Kindesalter. In Handb. Kinderh. (Pfaundler. M. & Schlossmann, A.) 4. Aufl., Berl., 1935, 10: 663-702. Weissenbach. Levy-Franckel [et al.] Spinnlosisme. Bull. Soc. fr. derm, syph., 1935, 42: 934.— Wise. V., & Sulzberger. M. B. Acquired progressive kinking of the scalp hair accompanied l>y changes in its pigmentation; correlation of an unidentified group of cases presenting cir- cumscribed areas of kinky hair. Arch. Derm. Syph., Chic, 1932, 25: 99-110. Also repr.—Wolter. A. Ueber eine neuartige Behandlung von Erkrankungen de- hehaarten Kopfes. Derm. Wschr., 1938. 107: 1172. ---- Epilation. See also subheadings Hypertrichosis; Mycosis. Billiard, J. L. *Etude critique de l'epilation the>apeutique. 136p. S? Par., 1930. Xiemoeller, A. F. Superfluous hair and its removal. 155p. 19}4cm. X. Y., 1939. Accident insurance; erysipelas following extraction of hair an accident. J. Am. M. Ass., 1940, 114: 2245.—Baer, H. L. Epilation and pain. Ai<-h. Derm. Syph., Chic, 1935, 32: 632.— Costello, M. J. How to remove superfluous hair. Hygeia, Clue', It) ID, 18: 584-6.—Friedmann, M. Zur Ge- -chi( hie der Entfernung unei wiinschter Haare. Derm. Wschr., 1930, 90: 4 51.— Goodman, H. Superfluous hair. Am. J. l'liv-. Ther., 1930, 7: 208-10.—Jeanselme iV (.iraudeau. De l'epilation thorapeut ique. Rev. gen. clin. tie'?., 1928, 42: 353-7.—Kende, B. Neuer Epilaf ionsgriff. Wieu. Klin. Wschr., 1928, 41: 382.—Sabouraud, R. 1 )u role de l'epilation a la pince en dermatologie. Pre.-.-e med., 1931, 39: 113-5.—Schreus, H. T.t & Engelhardt, W. Enthaarungsmethoden und ihre Indi- kationsgehiete. Eortsel,. Ther., 1931, 7: 467-73. -Ubelhart, G. S., iv McAllister. J. K. Hair pulling device. U. S. Patent Off., 1935, No. 2, \] ■' r 7r:i■ ■: u 11 mn Thallium vergifteten Ratten. Klin. Wschr., !''-"' 8:3,'7-,i.. Buschke, A., & Langer, E. Die kombinierte I •..:... ,n.p.,'.o_r, -epilation. Derm. Wschr., 1927, 85: 1390-3 Beinerkung von Dr Stumpke] 1393. Also Ther. Gegenwart 1927, 68: 352-6.—Buschke, A., \ thallium acetate. Lancet, Lond., 1927, 1: 1290.—Divella, M. Della proprieta epilatrice dell'acetato talloso e sua etiologia (nota preventiva) Gior. ital. derm, sif., 1926, 67: 291-310.—Doczy, G. Beitriige zu der Frage der kombinierten Thallium-Rontgenepilation. Derm. Wschr., 1929, 89: 1806-9.—Dombrovsky. A. [Thallium epilation] Klin, med., Moskva, 1927, 5: 846-50.—Freeman, E. T. Epilation l>v thallium acetate. Irish. J. M. Sc, 1927, 6. ser., 318-20, pi.'—Gay Prieto, J. Contribution al estudio clfnico y experimental de la depilacion por las sales de talio. Progr. clin., Madr., 1927, 35: 761-6.—Gonzales. H. S. Modi- ficaciones que sufre el bulho piloso bajo la action del acetato de talio. Hosp. gem, Mex.. 1926, 1: 559-62, 4 pi— Heim- burger, L. F., & Yiu, C. ('. Thallium acetate as a depilatory. China M. J., 1931, 45: 742-9. Hofman, P. B. [Comparison of epilatorv and toxic effects of various combinations of uni- valent thallium] Vest, vener., 1937, 330-2.—Hykes, O. V., & Diakov. F. A. Antagonistic effect of potassium iodide in Oaldne.-s due to thallium acetate. Nature, Lond., 1935, 136: 685.—Katzenellenbogen. I. Beitrag zur Frage der Thallium- epilation. Derm. Wschr., 1929, 89: 1947-51.—Kleinman, G. N., & Grossman, M. S. [Epilation with thallium and Roentgen rays by Buschke's and hanger's methods in gum- matous affections] Vener. derm., Moskva, 1929, 6: 25-30.— Koszler, V. Zur Frage der Genese des Haarausfalls bei Thalli- umvergiftung. Wien. Arch. inn. Med., 1932, 22: 473-6.— Lavender, H. J. Epilation by ingestion of thallium acetate; report of 2 cases. J. Med., Cincin., 1930-31, 11: 309 — Lew, D. M. [Experiences with epilation by thallium acetate] Ned', tschr. geneesk., 1927, 71: pt 2, 2611.—Mahoney, W. Retrobulbar neuritis due to thallium poisoning from depilatory cream; report of 3 cases. J. Am. M. Ass., 1932, 98: 618-20. Also repr.—Mantarro, G. Esperimenti sulla depilazione del cuoio capelluto merce l'azione combinata del tallio e dei raggi Rontgen. Gior. ital. derm, sif., 1930, 71: 775-85.— Mashkilleison, L. N., & Arievich, A. M. fEpilatory properties and endurability of Prof. Lieberman's thallium plaster, ac- cording to data in complex work] Vest, vener., 1939, No. 9, 20-7.—Mgeubrov, M., & Landesmann, A. L'ac6tate de thallium comme moven epilatoire. Rev. fr. derm. v6ner., 1927, 3: 587-002.—Peli, G. Contribute alia conoscenza del dosaggio biologico-sperimentale dell'acetato di tallio a scopo alopecizzante e del salicilato di tallio non ancora conosciuto quale alopecizzante. Gior. ital. derm, sif., 1933, 74: 1613- 22, pi. Also Gazz. osp., 1934, 55: 419; 451.------& Benignetti, D. Dosaggio biologico-sperimentale di alcuni -ali di tallio a scopo alopecizzante: solfato di tallio, nitrato di tallio, carhonato di tallio. Gior. ital. derm, sif., 1935, 76: 1281-9.—Peter, G. Die Epilation mit Thallium-acetic oxy- dulat. Arch. Derm., 1926, 101: 438-50.------La methode du Dr Cicero pour l'epilation par l'acetate de protoxvde de thallium. Bruxelles med., 1920-27, 6: 1476-81.—Prebil, M. Ricerche farmacodinamiche sulla situazione neuroendocrina nei baniliini trattati con acetati di tallio in dose epilatoria. Cultura med. mod., Pal., 1930, 9: 1025-11. Ritter, H. Thalli- umacetat Epilation. Zbl. Haut (ie-chlkr., 1927-28, 25: 589. ------ & Karrenherg, C. L. Ein kasuistischer Beitrag zur Frage der Thalliumepiiation. Derm. Wschr., 1928, 86: 434-8. ------ Thalliumepiiation ode-r Rontgenentliaarung. Strah- lentherapie, 1930, 35: 116-22.—Rudy, A. Sevi-ie thallium acetate intoxication caused bv the use of a depilatory called Koremlu; report of case. N. England J. M., 1932, 207: 1151.— Schreiber, H. Ein Fall von Thalliumalopezie durch Ratten- gift. Deut. med. Wschr., 1937, 63: 306.—Stern, C, & Grevel, P. Ueber Lii'ahrungen mit der Epilation durch Thallium aceticum nach Buschke. Derm. Wschr., 1927, 85: 1021-4.— Stiimpke. Ueber Thallium-aceticum-Epilation beziehungs- weise ihre Kombination mit Kontgenstrahlen. Ibid., 1055-8.— Szentkiralyi, I. Sekundare Aniimie nach einer Thallium- aceticum-Epilation. Ibid., 1083-5.—Trufti, G. Sulla alopecia da talho: il meccanismo d'azione del tallio nella produzione della alopecia nei bambino. Gior. ital. derm, sif., 1928, 69: 60-80, pi.—Urabe, S. Experimentelle Untersuchungen iiber den Einfluss des Thalliums auf die Ziihne; iiber die allgemeine Thalhumvergiftung, insbesondere iiber den Haarausfall. Acta derm., Kyoto, 1935, 26: 73-92.—Waring, T. P. Another case of thallium poisoning following use of Koiemlu cream. J. Am. M. Ass., 1931, 97: 703. ---- Epilation, diathermic. n,Bo*r' H- „The technic of diathermic epilation. Am. J. Phys. Ther., 1932, 8: 273— Cateula, J. Nuevo tipo de pinza, empleada como elemento accesorio en la depilaci6n por dia- termocoagulacion. Sern. med., B. Air., 1939, 46: pt 2 628 — oner°,o', D\ Short U,IV(' ••l'iI"'"->n- Arch. Phys. Ther., 1939, 20: 101.—Lanan, K. L., ovet. vet., 1939, 16: 106.—Kuzmin, N. [On Rozov's paper Tiichorrhexis of horses] Ibid., No. 10-11, 96.—Lewis, G. M. Trichorrhexis nodosa. Arch. Derm. Syph., Chic, 1941 43: 866.—Marcoglou, A. E. Idiopathic trichoclasia of Jackson- Sabouraud; report of a case. Ibid., 1928, 17: 512-8.—Miescher, (i.. & Burckhardt, W. Familiare Trichorrhexis nodosa nut dominnntcm Erbgang. Schweiz. med. Wschr., 1937, 67: 82.— Rozov, A. A. [Trichorrhexis of the horse] Sovet. vet., 1939, 16: 67-9.—Su, Tsan-en. Trichorrhexis nodosa. China M. J., 1930, 44: 460-4, 4 pi.—Touraine, A., & Clerfeuille, G. Les diverses variet6s de trichontxie noueuse. Bull. Soc. fr. derm. syph., 1938, 45: 636-40.—Touraine, A., & Solente. Erythro- keratodermie du cuir chevelu et trichorrhexis nodosa familiales. Ibid., 1937, 44: 1011-4. Also Rev. fr. derm, vener., 1938, 14: 73.—Zingale, M. Trichorrhexis nodosa cirmcumscripta ed area Celsi. Gior. itaL derm. sif.. 1938. 79: 1023-9. ---- Trichostasis. See Hair follicle, Keratosis spinulosa. ---- Trichotillomania. See Hair-plucking. HAIRCUTTING [and shaving] Campani, A. Nuovo modello di pennello igienico per barba. Policlinico, 1922, 29: sez. prat., 520.—Clement, R. L'art de se bien raser. Presse med., 1938, 46: 585-7.—Davies, J. H. T. Another disease caused by women's fashions. Brit. M. J., 1930, 2: 61.—Hollander, L., & Casselman, E. J. Factors involved in satisfactory shaving. J. Am. M. Ass., 1937, 109: 95-101.— Konig. S. Ein neuer elektrischer Trocken-Rasierapparat. Zbl. Chir., 1934, 61: 1994.—Kritshevsky, W. Brushless shaving cream. U. S. Patent Off., 1939, No. 2,167,180; 1940, No. 2,195,713.—Kritzler. Ueber einen zweckmassigen Rasier- seifenersatz. Ther. Gegenwart, 1919, 60: 239.—Martin, A. Wie hat man einst rasiert? Fortsch. Med., 1932, 50: 139.— Mueller, I. Hypertrichosis als Folge von Haarschnitt. Miinch. med. Wschr., 1929, 76: 281.—Noury, P. Les cheveux courts, leur anciennete. Chron. med., 1926, 33: 348.—Robson, A. D. Preparation for applying to the hair and skin preparatory to dry-shaving. U. S. Patent Off., 1940, No. 2,227,321.—Seymour, R. J. The effect of cutting upon the rate of hair growth. Am. .1. Phvsiol., 1926, 78: 281-6.—Trotter, M. Hair growth and shaving. Anat. Rec. 1927-28, 37: 373-9. HAIRDRESSER [and dressing] See also Barber. Bellevatjx, B. de. Apologia de barbis; nunc primum ex MS. Add. 41997 Musaei Britannici ed. E. Ph. Goldschmidt. 96p. 8? Cambr., 1935. Ausiibung des Friseurhandwerks. Reichsgesundhbl., 1938, 13: 32.—Bordas. L'emploi de liquides inflammables ou toxiques dans les salons de coiffure. Ann. hyg., Par., 1935, n. ser., 13: 167-75.—Feil, A. Les methodes actuelles de certaines prati- ques de coiffures sont-elles toujours inoffensives? Bull. Acad, med., Par., 1932, 3. ser., 107: 985-8. Also Strasbourg med., 1933, 93: 86.—Forderung der Gesundheitspflege im Friseur- gewerbe. Reichsgesundhbl., 1936, 11: 887.—Friedmann, M. Ueber Berufsstigmen der Haarformer. Derm. Wschr., 1932, 95: 1429.—Fruhwald, R. Eine Berufsschwiele bei einer Friseuse. Ibid., 1746-8.—Gougerot & Decourt. Eczema dermite artificielle professionnelle anaphylactique chez un coiffeur. Bull. Soc. fr. derm, syph., 1932, 39: 704.—Hair- dressers (registration) bill. Pharm. J., Lond., 1939, 88: 407.— Hammer, J. A reference to foppish coiffures in Geoffrey of Monmouth. Speculum, Cambr., 1937, 12: 503-8.—Lewis, F. Dangers in the use of chemical hair straightener. J. Am. M. Ass., 1939, 112: 36.—Louste & Thibaut. Un cas rare de dermite professionnelle chez un coiffeur. Bull. Soc. fr. derm. syph., 1934, 41: 426-9.—Mehrarbeit fiir Jugendliche in Friseur- betrieben. Arbeitsschutz, 1939, 157.—Prusse; ordonnance du 6 decembre 1937, du Ministre de l'interieur du Reich et de Prusse, concernant l'exercice du metier de coiffeur. Prophyl. antivener., Par., 1938, 10: 640-6.— Spitz, J. Beauty parlor burns of the scalp; their cause, treatment and prevention. Med. World, 1938, 56: 384. HAIR dye. See also Henna; also Cosmetics; Eyebrow; Eyelash, &c. Hemmer, B. *Haarfarb- und Bleichmittel [Heidelberg] 15p. 22>2cm. Ludwigshafen a. Rh., 1936. Redgrove, H. S., & Foan, G. A. Hair dyes and hair-dyeing, chemistry and technique. New ed. 205p. 22}4cm. N. Y., 1939. Abecassis, A. A pi opos de la re^ponsabilite en mntiere d'accidents dus aux teint are's pour les cheveux. Ann. med. leg., 1939, 19: 416-8. (ox. H. E. Hair dyes; the functions and reactions of phenols. Analyst, Lond., i'.ltO, 65: 393-8.-— Deshusses, J., & Valencien, ('. Identification des bases organiques entrant, dans la composition des teintures pour cheveux. Mitt. Lebensmitteluntersuch., Bern, 1939, 30: 10; 1940, 31: 53.- Diasio, F. A. Clinical observations on the use of a bismuth compound as a hair dye. Med. J. & Rec, 1933 137: 404-8.—Eugatol, colorante inoffensivo dei eapelli. Gior. farm, chim., Tor., 1907, 56: 440.—Goldfarb, A. R. Remover for artificial colors from hair. U. S. Patent OIL, 1941, No. 2,236,970.—Grau, C. A. Tinturas para o cahelo. Farm, brasil., 1936, 11: No. 44, 23-5.—Gray, A. M. H., & Klaber, R. Involuntary dyeing of the hair. Brit. J. Derm. Syph., 1936, 48: 97; 193.—Kruchen, C. Gefiirbte Haare im Rontgenbild. Rontgenpraxis, 1937, 9: 640.—Orelup, J. W. Method of dyeing hair. U. S. Patent Off., 1940, No. 2,208,594.— Tinture per eapelli. Igiene & vita, 1934, 17: 175.—Van Tyen, B. J. Process and device for influencing the roots of the hair by means of chemical substances. U. S. Patent Off., 1940, No. 2,194,173.—Vidal, A., & Duquenois. Pour la teinture des cheveux le medecin consults doit savoir conseiller un produit sans danger. Concours med., 1940, 62: 674-6. ---- Poisoning. Delhaye, J. *Les accidents cutan^s des teintures capillaires en particulier des teintures a base de derives de l'aniline. 71p. 8? Par., 1936. Mutzel, A. *Hautveranderungen durch Haar- farbstoffe [Munchen] 18p. 8? Wiirzb., 1934. Puyatj, M. J. J. *La parapheiiylene diamine; les accidents cons6cutifs a son application; leur prophylaxie. 63p. 25cm. Bord., 1938. Baldridge, C. W. Macrocytic anemia with aplastic features following the application of synthetic organic hair dye. Am. J. M. Sc, 1935, 189: 759-65.—Brawley, F. Toxic effect of hair dye on eyes and skin. Med. Clin. N. America, 1934, 17: 1503-5.—Brossowa, J. [Case of poisoning by a hair dye] Med. prakt., Poznan, 1935, 9: 12-4.—Carratala, R. E., & Belbey, J. C. Trastornos psiquicos y nerviosos determinados por tinturas para el cabello. Rev. As. med. argent., 1934, 48: 412-7. Also Sem. med., B. Air., 1934, 41: 1727-31.—Close, W. J. A case of poisoning from hair dye (paraphenylene- diamine) Med. J. Australia, 1932, 1: 53.—Dangerous (A) hair dye. Brit. M. J., 1940, 1: 327.—David-Chausse, R. Des accidents cutanes provoqu6s par les teintures capillaires a base de paraphenylfine diamine. J. m6d. Bordeaux, 1935, 112: 458-60.—Duquenois, P. Contribution a l'etude medico- legal des intolerances causees par les teintures capillaires; dermite et eczema par sensibilisation. Ann. med. leg., 1939, 19: 661-9.—Griebel, C. Sind die modernen Haarfarben unschadlich? Umschau, 1935, 39: 728-30. ——— Inwieweit konnen die modernen Haarfarbemittel als unschadlich gelten? Zschr. Untersuch. Lebensmitt., 1935, 70: 61-76. ------ & Weiss, F. Nachweis von p-Phenylendiamin und anderen Diaminen in Haarfarbemitteln. Ibid., 1933, 65: 419-28.— Hair dyes; dermatitis attributed to use of dye. J. Am. M. Ass., 1938, 111: 2144.—Hellerstrom, I. S. [Dermatitis caused by dyeing of hair with Kleinol] Nord. med., 1939, 1: 631.— Injury to eye due to hair dye. J. Am. M. Ass., 1940, 114: 2330.-—Israels, M. C. G. Systemic poisoning by phenylene- diamine with report of a fatal case. Lancet, Lond., 1934, 1: 508-10 —Lagage, L. Phenomenes d'intoxication par la para- phenylimediamine consecutifs a l'emploi d'une teinture pour cheveux. Bull. Soc. fr. derm, syph., 1934, 41: 565-70.— Lankford, J. S. Hair dyes and their dangers. Med. Rec, Houston, 1933, 27: 289-91.—McCafferty, L. K. Hair dyes and their toxic effects; classification and description. Arch. Derm. Syph., Chic, 1926, n. ser., 14: 136-44.—Marc & Cheval- lier. Coloration des cheveux; accidents qu'elle peut occasioner. Gaz. san., Par., 1835, 4: 15.5-65.—Merlo, C. Sopra un raro caso di intossicazione mortale da applicazione di tintura per eapelli. Gazz. osp., 1928, 49: 1207-11.— Moran, C. T. Bilateral necrosis of the cornea following the use of hair dye on the eyebrows and lashes. J. Am. M. Ass., 1934 102- 286.—Nicolas, J., Carle, M., & Rousset, J. Dermite erythema- teuse et vesiculo-bulleuse intense generalis6e hyperpyretique par la teinture de cheveux a la paraphenylmethylene diamine. Bull. Soc. fr. derm, syph., 1937, 44: 527-30.—Peters, H. R., & Sacks, M. S. Systemic poisoning due to synthetic organic onio ¥S' «al case with aut°Psy- Ann. Int. M., 1938-39, 12: 2032-42— Rabut, R. Les metrites des teintures capillaires. Prat, med fr., 1935, 16: 281-8.—Risi, A. Lesioni epato-renali per avvelenamento subacuto da piombo acetato basico- parafeiulendiamma e pirogallolo contenuti nelle comuni w iTidS? oa£e11.1' Ar„ch- ,internat- P^rm. dyn., Par., 1937- 57: 118-27— Soriano, F., & Malbran, J. AmblioDias toxical por tintura del cabello. Rev. As. med. argent?T936 50 849-54.—Szanto J. [Experiments on toxicity of some hair- dyes] Orv. hetil., 1934, 78: 660-3.-Tzanck,A . Sm?, E & Delhaye, J. Dermites par teintures capillaires; es accidents cutanes des teintures capillaires a base de paraphlnvllne- diamine. Monde med., 1937, 47: 889-98.-VahSei A HAIR DYE 31 HAIR FOLLICLE Planque. Sur un cas de toxicodermie mortelle par teinture capillaire (Plomb) Ann. derm, syph., Par., 1930, 7. ser., 1: 1026-37. Haire, Norman, 1892- Hymen; or, the future of marriage. 195p. 16? Lond., K. Paul, & Co., 1927. ---- Some more medical views on birth control. 4 p. 1. 239p. 8? Lond., C. Palmer [1928] ---- Birth-control methods (contraception, abortion, sterilisation) 192p. pi. 8? Lond., G. Allen & Unwin [1936] Also editor of Encyclopaedia of sexual knowledge. 647p. 8! Lond., 1935. HAIR follicle. See also Acne; Carbuncle; Ecthyma; Folli- culitis; Furuncle; Impetigo; Lichen ruber; Pityriasis rubra pilaris, &c. Dubreuil, G. Les dispositifs vasculaires au niveau du collet des follicules pileux a sinus sanguin dans le groin du pore. C. rend. Soc. biol., 1937, 125: 649.—Gaujoux, E., & Bourret, M. Le soufre en applications externes dans les affections du follicule pilo-sebace. Marseille med., 1926, 63: 1757-64.— Hance, R. T. Mitosis in hair follicle cells of mice following X-radiation. J. Morph., 1940, 66: 409-22.— Jalowy, B. [Tumors of the hair follicles, simulating multiple sebaceous cystoma (steacystoma multiplex) and milium (milia)] Przegl. derm., Warsz., 1938, 33: 21-9.—Sabouraud, R. Sur quelques points de la pathologie du follicule pilaire et du poil. Bull. Soc. fr. derm, syph., 1935, 42: 868-85.—Shattuck, S. G. Eleidoma. Proc. R. Soc. M., Lond., 1913-14, 7: Path. Sect., 140.—Trotter, M. The activity of hair follicles with reference to pregnancy. Surg. Gyn. Obst., 1935, 60: 1092-5.—Whit- field, A. Hair follicles, abnormalities and diseases. In Brit. Encycl. M. Pract. (Rolleston, H.) Lond., 1937, 6: 162-70.— Zimmermann, K. W. Ueber einige Formverhaltnisse der Haarfollikel des Menschen. Zschr. mikr. anat. Forsch., 1935, 38: 503-53. ---- Epithelioma. Castro Palomino, J., A Romero, O. Sobre un caso de Iricobasalioma. Rev. med. cir. Habana, 1935, 40: 105-9.— D'Arrigo, G. L'epitelioma pilare. Rinasc. med., 1938, 15: 236.—Hamdi, H. Endothelioma peritheliale bulbi pilorum. Zschr. Krebsforsch., 1930, 32: 377.—Klaber, R. Two cases of tricho-epitheliomata with a rodent lesion. Brit. J. Derm. Syph., 1935, 47: 480.—Mashkilleison, L. N., A Smelov, N. S. [Trichobasalioma of face and scalp] Sovet. klin., 1931, 16: 393-8.—Picard, E., A Liegeois, P. Epitheliomas pilaires. f'ancer, Brux, 1931, 8: 121-31.—Schlammadinger, J. Cylin- drom und Trichoepithelioma papillosum multiplex. Arch. Derm. Syph., Berl., 1934-35, 171: 520 35. ---- Keratosis foUicularis. For Darier's disease see under Dyskeratosis. Endert, F. J. *Ein Fall von Keratosis follikularis (Siemens) mit ' Beziehungen zur Poikilodermia atrophicans vascularis (Jacobi) [Munster] 15p. 8? Dusseldorf, 1931. Aoki, T. Ueber die Keratosis foUicularis squamosa Dohi. Derm. Wschr., 1936, 102: 282-4.—Diasio, F. A. Keratosis foUicularis sine dyskeratosis; a nevoid anomaly of develop- ment; report of a case. Arch. Derm. Syph., Chic, 1932, 26: 00-7. Also repr.—Elliott, J. A., A Welton, D. G. Keratosis foUicularis. Ibid., 1940, 42: 354.—Gyorgy, E. [C-vitamin in foUicularis hyperkeratosis] Orv. hetil., 1936, 80: meU., 150. ----■— [New data on curative effect of vitamin C in follicular hyperkeratosis] Ibid., 1937, 81: 347. Also Arch. Derm. Syph., Berl., 1937, 175: 706-9.—Johnson, H. H. An unusual case of keratosis suprafollicularis with pili incarnati inciting foreign body reaction. Arch. Derm. Syph., Chic, 1940, 42: 371 — Jossel, B. Zur Kenntnis der sogenannten Alibertschen Tinea amiantacea (Keratosis foUicularis amiantacea Kiess) Derm. Wschr., 1932, 94: 677-80.—Oppenheim, M. Schmierolhaut, kenntlich Hyperpigmentation und Hyperkeratose, namentlich der Follikel. Wien. klin. WTschr., 1917, 30: 830.—Peck, S. M., Chargin, L., A Sobotka, H. Keratosis foUicularis (Darier's disease) a vitamin A deficiency disease. Arch. Derm. Syph., Chic, 1941, 43: 223-9.—Szathmary, S. [Keratosis hypo- vitaniinosa] B6rgy6gy. urol. vener. szemle, 1940, 18: 49. ---- Keratosis foUicularis: Type Kyrle. Andersen, M. [Kyrle's disease] Hospitalstidende, 1938, 81: Danksderm. selsk. forh., 36.—Bloch, B. Ueber einen schweren Fall von wahrscheinlich Kyrlescher Krankheit (Hyperkeratosis foUicularis et parafollicularis in cutem penetrans) mit Beteili- gung der Niigel und der Mundschleimhaut. In Ikonogr. derm. (Jadassohn A Zieler) Berl., 1932, 1-8, 2 pi.—Halter, K. Isoliert mamilliire Hyperkeratosis foUicularis et parafollicularis in cutem penetrans (Kyrle) Arch. Derm. Syph., Berl., 1937-38 176: 689-93.—Jersild, O., A Kristjansen, A. Un cas de la maladie de Kyrle (hyperkeratosis foUicularis et parafollicularis in cutem penetrans) Ann. derm, syph., Par., 1928, 6. ser., 9: 101-5.-—Pawloff, P. A. Zur Kasuistik der Kyrleschen Krank- heit; ein Fall von Hyperkeratosis foUicularis et parafollicularis in cutem penetrans. Arch. Derm. Syph., Berl., 1926, 152: 34-46.—Ullmo, A. Hyperkeratose foUiculaire et parafoUiculaire in cutem penetrans, ou maladie de Kyrle. Rev. fr. derm, vener., 1939. 15: 47-52. ---- Keratosis pilaris. Beres, E. Contribution a l'6tude de la ke>atose pilaire a debut brusque chez Padulte. 48p. 8? Par., 1928. Brocq, L. Lichen pilaire ou xerodermic pilaire sym6trique de la face. Ann. derm, syph., Par., 1889, 2. ser., 10: 339-42.— Costello. M. J. Follicular atrophic lichen planus. Arch. Derm. Syph., Chic, 1941, 43: 738.—Danlos. Lichen plan a localisa- tion pilaire simulant le pityriasis rubra de Devergie. Bull. Soc fr. derm, syph., 1905, 16: 313. Also Ann. derm, syph., Par., 1905, 4. ser., 6: 978. ------ A Gaston. Lichen plan a localisation pilaire, simulant le pityriasis rubra de Devergie; 6tudehistologique. Bull. Soc fr. derm, syph., 1906, 17: 14. Also Ann. derm, syph., Par., 1906, 4. ser., 7: 47.—Djemil, S. Keratoses pilaires prescorbutiques. Bull. Soc. path, exot., Par., 1926, 19: 6-8.—Fox, W. S. Case of lichen plano-pilaris. Proc. R. Soc. M., Lond., 1907-8, 1: Derm. Sect., 45.—Frucht- baum, L. M. Lichen planopilaris, Pringle. Arch. Derm. Syph., Chic, 1940, 42: 156.—Giovannini, S. Zur Histologic der Keratosis pilaris. Arch. Derm. Syph., Wien, 1902, 63: 163- 212, 5 pi. Also Gazz. med. ital., 1902, 53: 276. Also Gior. Accad. med. Torino, 1902, 4. ser., 8: 368-70.—Herxheimer. Demonstration dreier Falle von Lichen pilaris capitis. Verh. Deut. derm. Ges., 1908, 10: 322-4.—Ingram, J. T. Keratosis pilaris. Proc. R. Soc M., Lond., 1926-27, 20: Sect. Derm., 89.—Jonquieres, E. J. Liquen piano peripilar. Rev. As. med. argent., 1937, 50: 503.—Kissmeyer, A. Une forme rare de lichen plan papules perifolliculaires corneennes en pseudo- comedons. Rev. fr. derm, vener., 1933, 9: 528-31.—Macleod, J. M. H. Case of Uchen planus et pdaris in a Uttle girl, aged 8 years. Brit. J. Derm., 1907, 19: 76-8.—Pautrier, L. M. Lichen plan peri-pilaire. Bull. Soc. fr. derm, syph., 1937, 44: 240-4.—Pignot, M. K6ratose pilaire. In Nouv. prat. derm. (Darier, Sabouraud [et al.]) Par., 1936, 7: 83-91.—Roxburgh, A. C. Lichen plano-pilaris; bismuth eruption? Proc. R. Soc. M., Lond., 1939-40, 33: 581. ------ & Klaber, R. Lichen plano-pilaris; bismuth eruption? Brit. J. Derm. Svph., 1940, 52: 263.— Savill, T. D. Case of lichen plano-pilaris. Proc. R. Soc M., Lond., 1907-8, 1: Derm. Sect., 169. Also Lancet, Lond., 1908, 2: 1594—6.—Siemens, H. Uchen pilaris univer salis. Derm. Wschr., 1941, 112: 281. ---- Keratosis spinulosa. Adamson, H. G. Lichen pilaris, seu spinulosus. Brit. J. Derm., 1905, 17: 39; 77; 1906, 18: 402. ------ Lichen spinu- losus. Ibid., 1907, 19: 15.—Barber, H. W. Case of lichen spinulosus. Proc. R. Soc. M., Lond., 1926-27, 20: Sect, Derm., 28-30. Also Brit. J. Derm. Syph., 1935, 47: 470.—Bloom, D. Lichen planus associated with lichen spinulosus-like lesions. Arch. Derm. Syph., Chic, 1937, 36: 881.—Boncinelli, IT. Lichen spinulosus o spinulosismo? Boll. Sez. reg. Soc ital. derm., 1936, 14: 141.—Bottelli, C. A proposito di un caso di cheratosi foUicolare spinulosa; note cliniche ed istologiche. Gior. ital. mal. vener., 1910, 45: 432-44, pi.—Bowen, J. T. A case of lichen spinulosus [lichen pilaris seu spinulosus of the English writers] J. Cut. Dis. incl. Syph., 1906, 24: 416-8. Also repr.—Bunch, J. L. Case of lichen spinulosus. Proc. R. Soc. M., Lond., 1907-8, 1: Derm. Sect., 10:—Burgess, J. F. Trichostasis spinulosa. Arch. Derm. Syph., Chic, 1932, 25: 40-51.—Cavellucci, V. Su tre casi di cheratosi spinulosa, di cui due a carattere famUiale (contributo anatomo-clinico e patogenetico) Gior. ital. derm, sif., 1929, 70: 1324-32, pi — Corson, E. F. Trichostasis spinulosa. Arch. Derm. Syph., Chic, 1938, 38: 363-6.—Cottini, G. B. Lo stato attuale del problema deUe cheratosi follicolare e dello spinulosismo. Riforma med., 1936, 52: 1212-9.—Efron, N. S., A Pospelov, W. A. Zur Pathogenese des Lichen spinulosus Crocker- Adam.son. Arch. Derm. Syph., Berl., 1927, 153: 257-61 — Ellis, F. A., A Kirby-Smith, H. Lichen planus et acuminatus atrophicans, Feldman; folliculitis decalvanset lichen spinulosus Little. Arch. Derm. Syph., Chic, 1941, 43: 628-35.—Fanburg, S. J. Trichostasis spinulosa. Ibid., 1933, 27: 274-6.—Feld- man, S. Lichen planus et acuminatus atrophicans; foUiculitis decalvans et lichen spinulosus of Little. Ibid., 1936, 34: 378- 97.—Ferrari, A. V. Sopra un caso di_ cheratosi spinulosa successiva a trattamento con acetato di tallio. Gior. ital. derm, sif., 1929, 70: 100-11.—Forman, L. Lichen spinulosus and lichen planus. Proc. R. Soc. M., Lond., 1938-39, 32: Sect. Derm., 1031.—Gross, P. Lichen planus spinulosus et atrophi- cus, lichen planus et acuminatus atrophicus, Feldman; folli- culitis decalvans et atrophicans, Graham Little. Arch. Derm. Syph., Chic, 1941, 43: 727; 749.—Hare, T. A congenital abnormality of hair folhcles in dogs resembling trichostasis spinulosa. J. Path. Bact., Lond., 1932, 35: 569-71, pi.— Jona, G. Contributo alio studio dell'eziopatogenesi della keratosis spinulosa. Dermosifilografo, 1931, 6: 27-39.—Lang, HAIR FOLLICLE 32 HAIR FOLLICLE M. Beitrag zu den atrophlsierenden follikularcn Keratosen. Arch. Derm. Syph., Berl., 1926, 152: 756 71.— Leven. Kasui- stischcr Beitrag zur Keratosis foUicularis spinulosa decalvans. Derm. Wschr., 1933, 96: 341.—Levi, I. Contributo alio studio della patogenesi della cheratosi spinulosa. Gior. ital. derm, sif., 1928. 69: 1030-8, 3 pi. Lewandowsky, F. Ueber Lichen spinulosus. Arch. Derm. Syph., Lpz., 1905, 73: 343-02.— Lortat-Jacob A Legrain. Lichen spinulosus consecutif a un lichen plan i i- i. Bull. Soc. fr. derm, syph., 1927, 34: 692.— Mavnard, M. T. R. Lichen spinulosus, acquired. Arch. Deun. Svph., Chic, 1940, 41: 1142.—Mazzanti, C. Sovra un caso di cheratosi spinulosa in soggetto con infantUismo. Der- mosifilografo, 1928, 3: 51-65, pi.—Memmesheimer. Keratosis spinulosa. Derm. Wschr., 1937, 105: 1319.—Muronenko, N. F. [Cases of Crocker-Adamson's lichen spinulosus] Omsky med. J., 1928, 3: 49-51.—Nunez Lozano, E. R., & Brillo, A. Liquen espinuloso v seudo-pelada de Brocq. Rev. As. med. argent., 1939, 53: 913.—Perpignano. ('.. Cheratosi spinulosa a carattere famiidiare. Dermosifilofriafo, 1938, 13: 442-9.—Peters, A. D. K. Lichen pilaris seu spinulosus. Proc. R. Soc. M., Lond., 1938 39, 32: Sect. Derm., 1031.—Photinos, P. Lichen spinu- losus et pseudopelade de Brocq; leur association et guerison du lichen spinulosus par les ravons ultra-violets. Discuss. Congr. derm. syph. fr., 1939, 4. Congr., 272-5.—Piccardi. Keratosi spinulosa (lichen spinulosus degli autori inglesi) Gior. ital. mal. vener., 1900, 41: 597.—Pisacane, C. Contributo alio studio della cheratosi spinulosa. Arch. ital. derm, sif., 1931-32, 7: 479-95.—Poschacher, A. Ueber Trichostasis spinulosa. Acta derm, vener., Stockh., 1925,6: 107-17.—Ramos e Silva, J. Sobre a keratose espinulosa. Brasil. med., 1929, 43: 616-21.— Robba, G. Lichen pigmentoso con alopecia da spinulosismo. (dor. ital. derm, sif., 1934, 75: 1961-74, 2 pi.—Siemens. Keratosis foUicularis spinulosa decalvans. Arch. Derm. Syph., Perl., 1926, 151: 384-6.—Szodoray, L. Trichostasis spinulosa (Synonyme: Thysanothrix Franke, Keratosis spinulosa cum trichostasi Galewsky, Lanugocomedo Csillag) Dermatologica, Basel, 1939, 79: 144—50.—Unterkircher, J. Keratosis spinulosa und Pseudopelade (Brocq) Derm. Wschr., 1933, 97: 1026-30. ---- Sycosis [coccogenic] For lupoid sycosis see Ulerythema. Ayers, S., jr. Two cases for diagnosis, sycosis vulgaris? lupus civ thematosus? Arch. Derm. Syph., Chic, 1938, 37: 1001. Barbers' itch. J. Am. M. Ass., 1934, 102: 1700.— Bencdek, T. Schizosaccharomycosis sycosiformis; Beitrag zur \etioloirie und Pathogenese der sogenannten Sycosis simplex s. nonparasitaria. Derm. Wschr., 1928, 86: 425-33.—Bezecny, R. Sveosis profunda staphylogenes. Arch. Derm. Syph., Berl., 1930, 161: 658-60.—Diasio, F. A. Problems in dermatology; recalcitrant sycosis vulgaris. Med. Rev. of Rev., 1931, 37: 85-9.—Dowling, G. B. Sycosis of the scalp with cicatricial alopecia. Proc. R. Soc. M., Lond., 1934, 27: Sec. Derm., 296.— Esquier A Escartefigue. Sycosis grave de la moustache et de la barbe. Bull. Soc. fr. derm, syph., 1931, 38: 887-90.—Haldin- Davis, H. Barber's rash. Practitioner, Lond., 1936, 136: 586-94.—Hall, T. B. Dermatitis papiUaris capiUitii and sycosis vulgaris with hypovitaminosis; report of a case. Arch. Derm. Svph., Chic, 1936, 33: 880-4.—Ingram, J. T. Sycosis barbae. ' Brit. M. J., 1929, 2: 620. •-----■ Seborrhoeic sycosis. Brit. J. Derm. Syph., 1938, 50: 59-66.—Jelbart, C. E. Twelve months of sycosis barbae. Med. J. Australia, 1938, 1: 896.—May, J., A Costa, R. Sicosis micosica de la barba y del cueUo. Rev. urug. derm, sif., 1938, 3: 191-6.—Naegeli, O., & Zurukzoglu, S. Sycosis vulgaris und Herpesvirus. Zbl. Bakt., 1. Abt, 1935-36, 135: 297-9.—Rabut, R. Le sycosis. Hopital, 1931, 19: 450-2.—Sabouraud, R. Etude iconographique de la pustule staphylococcique et des lesions derivees d'elle; les sycosis nodulaires (plasmomes) Ann. derm, syph., Par., 1926, 6. ser., 7: 129-41.—Schiller, A. R., Hasley, C. K., A Dixon, R. S. Sycosis -vulgaris. Arch. Derm. Syph., Chic, 1940, 41: 1116.—Sellei, J. Die Sycosis seborrheica chronica. Derm. Wschr., 1930, 91: 1438-40.—Sezary, A., A Terrasse, J. Sycosis vegetant. Bull. Soc. fr. derm, syph., 1933, 40: 569-71.—Shaffer L. W. Coccigenic sycosis. Arch. Derm. Syph., Chic, 1937, 35: 1188.—Throne, B., & Myers, C. N. Sycosis. Long Island M. J., 1926, 20: 276-80. ____ Sycosis: Treatment. Abramowitz, E. W. Sycosis vulgaris, improved by sul- fanilamide. Arch. Derm. Syph., Chic, 1938, 37: 1086 — Avit-Scott, J. The treatment of sycosis and allied follicular infections of the skin. Brit. J. Derm. Syph., 1933, 45: 190-3.— Badin, M. Sycosis non parasitaire de la moustache traite par les rayons X. Gaz. sc. med. Bordeaux, 1908, 29: 17.— Beatty, J. Sycosis and its treatment. Clin. J., Lond., 1935, 64: 415-8.—Benedek, T. Sycosis simplex; its course, etiology, pathogenesis and therapeutics. Urol. Cut. Rev., 1932, 36: 733-43.—Bering, F. Die Rontgenbestrahlung der Sycosis coccogenes. Rontgenpraxis, 1938, 10: 740-2.—Braude, R., & Sarchi, M. Zur Klinik, Histologic und Therapie der Sycosis non parusitariu. Acta derm, vener., Stockh., 1929, 10: 153- 85.—Buisson, M. Alcune osservazioni sulle cause di recidiva delle f-icosi volgare del labbro superiore sottoposta al tratta- mento rontgen. Radiol, med., Milano, 1934, 21: 1054-63, pi —Burgess, N. A case of seborrhoeic sycosis with recovery after tonsillectomy. Brit. J. Derm. Syph., 1938, 50: 311.— Cannon, A. B. Sycosis vulgaris, showing results of manual epilation. Arch. Derm. Syph., Chic, 1937, 36: 1208. -Foit. H. Sycosis vulgaris treated with electro-coagulation. Med. Rev. of Rev., 1926, 32: 115-7.—Fidanza. E. I». Ueber die Be- handlung der eitrigen Bartflechte mit Jodisan. Derm. Wschr., 1929, 89: 1239.—Fradet. Sycosis de la levre supeneure. Arch. Doyen, Par., 1910-11, 1: 578.—Gauducheau, R. A propos du traitement du sycosis staphylococcique. Arch. electr. med., 1921, 31: 10.—Jaulin. Traitement du sycosis staphylococcique par la radiotherapie et l'ion zinc. Ibid., 1920 30: 321.—Katsarov, S. N. [Treatment of non-parasitic sycosis] Vest, vener., 1937, No. 9-10, 918-22.—Levy-Franrkel, A. Les sveosis et leur traitement. J. med. Paris, 1927, 46: 360.—Lyons, M. A. The technique of the treatment of sycosis barbae bv means of X-rays. Phys. Ther., 1928, 46: 252-4.— Maday, T. H. Cold-quartz ultraviolet i a\ s in the treatment of sveosis barbae. Clin. M. A S„ 1936, 43: 394.—Marin, A. Sycosis et rayons X. Presse med., 1932, 40: 1673-5. Also Union med. Canada, 1932, 61: 11 17. Also Canad. M. Ass. J., 1933 28:621-4. ------• La radiotherapie du sycosis vulgaire. Union med. Canada, 1932, 61: 1220-5.—Mienicki, M. de, & do Sawicki, E. Sur l'application du cholevale dans le traite- ment du sycosis simple. Acta derm, vener., Stockh., 1929, 10: 463-8.—Parkhurst, H. J. Uoccogenous sycosis; treatment. J. Michigan M. Soc, 1940, 39: 255-8.—Paterson, J. Sycosis and sycotic Co. (Paterson) Brit. Homoeop. J., 1933, 23: 160-86 4 pi.—Pignot, M. Le traitement du sycosis sous- narinaire. Progr. med., Par., 1937, 713.—Scott, J. A. Treat- ment of chronic coccogenic sycosis (barbers' rash) Brit. M. J., 1929, 2: 621.—Senin, A. S. Die Behandlung der Sykosis mit Brillantgrun. Derm. Wschr., 1931, 93: 1729-31.—Traub, E F Sycosis vulgaris; roentgen ray dermatitis; epithelioma. Arch. Derm. Svph., Chic, 1937, 35: 354.—Tzanck, A., & Lewi, S. Traitement du sycosis par le lugol intraveineux goutte a goutte. Bull. Soc fr. derm, syph., 1938, 45: 584.— White, H. P. Zur Behandlung der Sykosis, nebst einer Be- merkung iiber den Parafinkrebs. Derm. Wschr., 1930, 91: 1873-6.—Whitehead, W. D. Sycosis vulgaris; its cUnical manifestations and treatment. Pennsylvania M. J., 1938-39, 42: 1193-6.—Zenin, A. S. [Experiments in treatment of sycosis vulgaris with brilliant green] Vrach. gaz., 1931, 35: 522-5. HAIRLESSNESS. See also Ectodermosis, congenital. Ktjhn, E. [S.] *Beitrage zur Kenntnis der Hypotrichosis congenita bei Tieren [Gottingen] 18p. 8? Marb., 1936. Broili, F. Ein Rhamphorhynchus mit Spuren von Haar- bedeckung. Sitzber. math, naturwiss. Abt. Bayer. Akad. Wiss., 1927, 49-67, 4 pi.—Clark, F. H. Postjuvenal nude in the deer-mouse. J. Hered., 1939, 30: 213-5— Crew, F. A. E., & Mirskaia, L. The character hairless in the mouse. J. Genet., Lond., 1931, 25: 17-24, 2 pi.—David, L. T. The external expression and comparative dermal histology of hereditary hairlessness in mammals. Zschr. Zellforsch., 1931-32, 14: 616-719.—Fleischmann, O. Die Bedeutung der Anidrosis hypotrichotica in erblicher und klinischer Hinsicht. Arch. Rassenb., 1935, 29: 257-77.—Gentilli, M. Ipotrichia congenita in due fratelli. Dermosifilografo, 1937, 12: 492-507.—Henckel, K. O. Hypotrichosis congenita bei eineiigen Drillingen. Klin. Wschr., 1935, 14: 428.—Howard, A. Rhino, an allele of hairless in the house mouse. J. Hered., 1940, 31: 466-70.-— Kwiatkowski [Atrichia congenita universalis] Przegl. derm., Warsz, 1936, 31: 182.—Lebedinsky, N. G., & Dauvart, A, Atrichosis und ihre Vererbung bei der albinotischen Hausmaus. Biol. Zbl., 1927, 47: 748-52.—Letard, E. L'heredite mende- lienne du caractere peau nue chez le chien. C. rend. Soc. biol., 1930, 103: 1135.—Milian A Dreyfus See. Hyperkeratose congenitale avec agenesie pilaire. Bull. Soc. fr. derm, syph., 1926, 33: 180-2.—Relationship between hairless calves in California and Texas herds. J. Hered., 1935, 26: 355.— Roberts, E. The effect of cysteine on hereditary hypotrichosis in the rat (Mus norvegicus) J. Biol. Chem., 1937, 118: 627-30. ------ Quisenberry, J. H., A Thomas, L. C. Hereditary hypothrichosis in the rat (Mus norvegicus) J. Invest. Derm., 1940, 3: 1-29.—Sein, M. Congenital and familial absence of hair from the whole surface of the body. Lancet, Lond., 1936, 2: 564.—Thigpen, L. W. Comparative histological studies on hairless mammals, with some genetic notes. Abstr. Theses Univ. Pittsburgh, 1930, 6: 191-7.—Touraine, A. Anidrose avec hypotrichose et anodontie (complexe majeur de la dys- plasie ectodermique hereditaire avec anidrose) Bull. Soc fr. derm, syph., 1935, 42: 1529-39.—Woringer, P. Hypoplasie congenitale des cheveux. Ibid., 1937, 44: 2178-83. HAIR-PLUCKING. See also in 3. ser. Trichotillomania. Barahal, H. S. The psychopathology of hair-plucking, trichotillomania. Psychoanal. Rev., 1940 27- 291-310__ Beinhauer, L. G. Trichotillomania. Arch. Derm Svn'h Chad' S \\:.%f 10 vcars' work. U. S. Nav. M. BuU., 1929, 27: 568-7!.—Rainey, V. G. A new prehistoric culture in Haiti. Proc. Nat. Acad. Sc. V. S., 1936, 22: 4-8.—Simpson, ('. E. The voduu service in ncu tiiern Haiti. Am. Anthrop., 1940, 42: 236-54. HAITIXGER, Max. Die Fluoreszenzanalyse in der Mikrochemie. vii, 192p. illust. tab. 8? Wien, E. Haim & Co., 1937. ---- Fluorescenzmikroskopie; ihre Anwen- dung in der Histologic und Chemie. viii, 108p. illust. 4 pi. 23cm. Lpz., Akad. Verlagsk., 1938. HAITZ, Ernst. Tafeln zur binokularen Unter- suchung des Gesichtsfeldzentrums vermittelst des Stereoskops. 3. Aufl. 14p. 7 pi. 32? Munch., J. F. Bergmann, 1923. Also 4. Aufl. 15p. 7 pi. 1929. HAJDA, Herman. *Valeur et resultats prati- ques de la gono-reaction. 48p. 8? Geneve, Impr. Commerce, 1932. HAJEK, Karl, 1878-1935. Nekrolog. Wien med. Wschr., 1935, 85: 396. HAJEK, Leo. Herstellung und methodische Verwertung von Schallaufnahmen. p. 1307-82. 8? Berl., 1937. In Handb. biol. Arbeitsmeth. (Abderhalden, E.) Berl., 1937, Abt. 5. T. 7. 2. Halfte. HAJEK, Markus, 1851- Pathology and treatment of the inflammatory diseases of the nasal accessory sinuses. Transl. and edit, by Joseph D. Heitger & French K. Hansel. 5. ed. rev. 2v. xxiv, 702p. paged consec. roy. 8? S. Louis, C. V. Mosby Co., 1926. ---- Pathologie und Therapie der Erkran- kungen des Kehlkopfes, der Luftrohre und der Bronchien. p. 1. iii-xiv, 705p. 495 illust. roy. 8? Lpz., C. Kabitzsch, 1932. For biography see Wien. med. Wschr., 1931, 81: 1547 (G. Hofer) HAJEN, Heinrich Friedrich, 1898- *Ueber die Beziehung des intrakutanen Ge- websdruckes zur Quaddelbildung; Untersuchun- gen fiber den intrakutanen Gewebsdruck. p.203- 13. 8? Berl., J. Springer, 1927. Also Zschr. ges. exp. Med., 1927, 57: HAJEN, Rudolf, 1903- *Ueber den Verlauf des Pleuraempyems [Kiel] 46p. 8? Ratzeburg, H. H. C. Freystatzky, 1926. HAJNALI, Joseph. *Zur Differentialdiagnose der Sclerosis multiplex cerebrospinalis [Basel] 23p. 8? S. Louis (Haut-Rhin) S. Koppel [1927] HAKENKAMP, Bernhard, 1908- *Ueber den Einfluss der Monobromessigsaure auf die Gerinnung der Milch [Munster-Westf.] 15p. 21cm. Werne a. d. Lippe, F. Grube, 1935. HAKEWILL, George. The vanity of the eye ... for the comfort of a gentlewoman bereaved of her sight. 3. ed. enl. 3 p. 1. 170p. 9 1. 16? Oxford, Joseph Barnes, 1615. HAKIM, Djahanguir, 1910- Contribu- tion a l'etude de la maladie de Bowen [Lausanne] 95p. 241,cm. Par., L. Rodstein, 1937. HAKIM, Manoutchehr, 1911- *Re- cherches sur l'articulation sacro-iliaque chez l'homme et chez les anthropoides. 96n 8° Par., M. Vigne, 1937. HAKIM, Siavouche. *Contribution a l'etude de Taction de la vitamine B2 sur la tonicity uterine. 28p. 22>2cm. Lausanne, C. Risold 1939. HALA, William Wendell, 1883- See Power, Henry D'Arcy, & Hala, WiUiam W. Principles of pathology for practitioners and students. 787d rov 8° N. Y., 1929. ^* y* HALATSCHEV, Eftim [N.] 1906- *Para- dentose im Klimakterium. 23p. 8? Erlangen, M. Dores, 1933. HALATSCHEV, Iwan [N.] 1904- *Der transperitoneale, cervicale Kaiserschnitt im Jahre 1926. 24p. 8? Munch. [F. Pinn] 1928. HALATSCHEWA, Nadejda, 1911- *Der Nachschmerz nach Zahnextraktionen; seine Aetio- logie und Therapie. 15p. 8? Miinch. [Bayer. Dr. 1934—35] HALBACH, Hans Heinrich, 1911- *Ueber die durch Pneumokokken verursachte krypto- genetische Peritonitis. 39p. tab. 20^cm. Bonn, H. Schonershoven, 1936. HALBACH, Julius, 1912- *Ein Beitrag zur Periarteriitis nodosa [Munster] 28p. 2 pi. 20>2cm. Werne a. d. Lippe, F. Grube, 1937. HALBACH, Margarete, 1907- *Ueber Arthritis gonorrhoica der Kiefer- und Kehlkopf- gelenke. 36p. 8? Bonn, H. Trapp, 1931. HALBAN, Henryk, 1870-1933. Sieradzki, W. [Obituary] Polska gaz. lek., 1933, 12: 1005. HALBAN, Josef, 1870-1937. Gynakologische Operationslehre. x, p. 1 1. 448p. 338 illust. roy. 8? Berl., Urban & Schwarzenberg, 1932. See also Winter, Georg, & Halban, Josef. Lehrbuch der operativen Geburtshilfe. 2. Aufl. 556p. roy. 8? Berl., 1934. For biography see Wien. klin. Wschr., 1937, 50: 914 (W. Weibel) Also Wien. med. Wschr., 1937, 87: 626-8 (W. Latzko) Also Zbl. Gyn., 1937, 61: 1458-66, portr. (R. Kohler) ---- & SEITZ, Ludwig. Biologie und Patho- logie des Weibes; ein Handbuch der Frauen- heilkunde und Geburtshilfe, und Registerband. 15v. roy. 8? Berl., Urban & Schwarzenberg. 1924—29. HALBEISEN, Gunther, 1904- Unter- suchungen iiber die Todesursachen der Kinder, die in der Zeit vom 1. VI. 1923 bis 1930 wahrend der Geburt und innerhalb der ersten 9 Tage verstorben sind [Wurzburg] 38p. tab. 8? Lippstadt, Thiele, 1931. HALBEISEN, Heinz, 1910- *Absolute Magenfunktionspriifungen bei Ulcus duodeni- Kranken ohne und unter Atropin. 26p. 8? Bonn, A. Brand, 1935. HALBEISEN, Magdalene, 1908- *Ein Fall von isolierter Keratitis luposa im Anschluss an Lupus faciei [Wurzburg] lOp. 8? Ochsen- furt, Fritz & Rappert, 1935. HALBERSTADT, Hans, 1912- *Die Bedeutung der Mundbakterien fiir die Zahn- heilkunde, insbesondere fur die Entstehung und Behandlung der Karies [Frankfurt] 19p. 21cm. Kassel, Gebr. Miiller, 1938. HALBERSTAEDTER, Ludwig. See Guhrauer, H., Halberstaedter, L. [et al.] Licht, Biolo- gie und Therapie Rontgen [&c] 786p. 8? Berl., 1929. -— & SIMONS, Albert. Die Wirkung der Radium-, Kathoden-, Rontgen- und Licht- strahlen auf die blutbildenden Organe und daa Blut. p. 1419-1520. Berl., Urban & Schwarzen- berg, 1932. A HittmSrjfte *' Bd' Handb- aUg" H*imat. (H. Hirschfeld & HALBERSTAEDTER, Walda Eva, 1899- *Hautveranderungen nach Kohlenoxydvereif- tung. 17pp. 8? Konigsb. i. Pr., J. Raabe, 1927. HALBERT, Blanche. Hospitals for rural communities. 42p. 8? Wash., 1937. Forms Farmers BuU. No. 1792, U. S. Dep. Agr. HALBFAS, Josef, 1908- *Beitrage zur Phannakobgie der Harze. 21p. 8? Wiirzb., HALBFASS,' Karl, 1906- *Versuche iiber die Feststellung der Trachtigkeit des Rindes HALBFASS 35 HALDIMANN durch den Nachweis der Geschlechtshormone in der Milch [Giessen] 28p. 8? Borna, R. Noske, 1933. HALBIG, Franz. Der Kampf gegen das Rauchgift Kohlenoxd unter besonderer Beriick- sichtigung der Zenteralheizungen und Zimmerofen. 42p. 8? Diisseld., Selbstverlag des Verfassers, 1930. HALBINGER, Liesel, 1909- *Polster- artige Hyperkeratosen iiber den Fingergelenken [Munchen] 19p. 8? Speyer, Pilger, 1937. HALBJAHRESVERZEICHNIS der Neuer- scheinungen des deutschen Buchhandels; mit Voranzeigen, Verlags- undPreisanderungen;Stich- und Schlagwortregister. Lpz., v.266, i931- HALBRON, Paul, 1870- Les maladies infectieuses. viii, 190p. 16? Par., A. Maloine & fils, 1925. ---- Diagnostic medical pratique. 3 p. 1. 622p. 8? Par., F. Alcan, 1932. For biography see In Fasc. script. (Dartigues, L.) Par., 1932. 3: 302-4. HALDIMANN, Jean. Contribution a l'etude des intoxications par l'aniline; anemie aplastique grave dans un cas d'intoxication chronique. 20p. 8? Lausanne, B. Schwabe & cie, 1929. HALDIN-DAVIS, Haldinstein David. Mod- ern skin therapy. 128p. 8? Lond., J. Cape [1930] ---- Skin diseases in general practice; their recognition and treatment. 3. ed. xiii, 400p. illust. pi. 8? Lond., H. Milford, 1937. HALE, Annie Riley, 1859- These cults; an analysis of the foibles of Dr Morris Fishbein's Medical follies and an indictment of medical practice in general [&c] viii, 257p. 8? N. Y., Nat. Health Found., 1926. ---- The medical voodoo. 338p. 8? N. Y., Gotham House, 1935. HALE, Edwin Moses, 1829- Charac- teristics of the new remedies. 3. ed. xvi, 544p. 8? Detr., Lodge's Homoeop. Pharm., 1873. ---- Heart, and how to take care of it. 94p. 18? N. Y., A. L. Chatterton Pub. Co., 1880. ----& WILLIAMS, Charles A. Compendium of health pertaining to the physical life of man and the animals which serve him, including the horse, ox, sheep [&c] 2v. xxii, 945p. paged consec. 4? Chic, Am. Book Co., 1884. HALER, David Henry, 1906- Aids to pathological technique, x, 187p. diagrs. 16? Lond., Bailliere, Tindall & Cox, 1933. HALES, Stephen, 1677-1761. IRiography] Am. J. Surg., 1934, n. ser., 24: 190, portr.— Clark-Kennedy, A. E. Stephen Hales; physiologist and botan- ist. Nature, Lond., 1927, 120: 228-31. HALEVI, Jehuda, 1086-1142. Schiffmann, S. Jehuda Halevi, physician and poet. Med. J. & Rec, 1932, 135: 299-301. HALE-WHITE, William, 1857- Materia medica, pharmacy, pharmacology and thera- peutics. 19. ed. viii, 712p. 18? Lond., J. & A. Churchill, 1927. Also 21. ed. with A. H. Douth- waite. x, 547p. 1932. Also 23. ed. rev. by A. H. Douthwaite. xi, 562p. 1937. ---- Great doctors of the nineteenth century. vii, 325p. 8? Lond., E. Arnold & Co. [1935] ---- Keats as doctor and patient. 96p. pi. 8? Lond., Oxford Univ. Press, 1938. For biography see Guy's Hosp. Gaz., Lond., 1937, 51: 19, portr. 21. HALFF, Georg [Friedrich August] 1899- *Osteomyelitis nach Operationen an Schadel- und Gesichtsknochen. 20p. 8? Berl., E. Ebering, 1926. HALFORD, George Britton, 1824-1920. Barrett, J. The Halford oration. Med. J. AustraUa, 1932, 2: 707-18.—Kenny, A. L. Halford the man. Ibid., 1941, 1: 129-34.—Osborne, W. A. George Britton Halford; his life and work. Ibid., 1929, 1: 64-71. HALIBUT [and oil] See also Fish-liver oil; Vitamin A. Ahmad, B. Observations on the vitamin-A value of haUbut- liver oil. Ind. M. Gaz., 1935, 70: 70.—Evers, N., Jones, A. G., & Smith, W. Characteristics of halibut-liver oUs of the 1935 season. Analyst, Lond., 1936, 61: 7-11.—Haines, R. T. M., & Drummond, J. C. The properties of haubut-liver oil. Brit. M. J., 1933, 1: 559-61. ----— Characteristics of halibut-Uver oils. Analyst, Lond., 1936, 61: 2-7.—Halibut-liver oil. J. Am. M. Ass., 1936, 107: 1969. Also Pharm. J., Lond., 1934, 132: 253. Also In New Modern Drugs (Gutman, J.) 1936, No. 7, 9.—Helmer, A. C, & Jansen, C. H. Topical applications of vitamin A and of carotene; absorption of vitamin A from halibut- liver oil. Stud. Inst. Divi Thomae, Cincin., 1937, 1: 1-9.— Lovern, J. A., Mead, T. H., & Morton, R. A. Halibut intestinal oil. Biochem. J., Lond., 1939, 33: 338-43.—Lovern, J. A., & Sharp, J. G. The diet of the halibut and intensity of feeding, in relation to the vitamin A potency of the liver oU. Ibid., 1933, 27: 1470-8.—McKesson's halibut-Uver oil plain, 11 cc. J. Am. M. Ass., 1936, 107: 1969.—May, E. W., & Wygant, T. M. The prophylactic use and tolerance of haliver oU with viosterol in premature and weakUng infants. J. Pediat., S. Louis, 1934, 4: 226-37.—Spalding, J. A. Haliver oU. Maine M. J., 1934, 25: HALBRON, Pierre, 1909- Contribu- tion a l'6tude de certaines interreactions neuro- vegetatives de l'oeil et du nez. 206p. 8? Par., Pres. Univ. France, 1936. HALDANE, Charlotte. Motherhood and its enemies. 2 p. 1. 255p. 8? Lond., Chatto & Windus, 1927. HALDANE, John Burdon Sanderson, 1892- Callinicus; a defence of chemical warfare. 2 p. 1. 84p. 16? N. Y., E. P. Dutton & co. [1925] ---- Enzymes, vii, 235 [l]p. 8? Lond., Longmans, Green & co., 1930. ---- Heredity and politics. 185p. tab. diagrs. 8? N. Y., W. W. Norton & co. [1938] ---- The chemistry of the individual, being the 38th Robert Boyle lecture delivered before the Oxford University Junior Scientific Club on June 12, 1936. 17p. 8? Lond., Oxford Univ. Press, 1938. ---- Adventures of a biologist, vii p.; 281p. diagr. 22y2cm. N. Y., Harper & brothers [1940] ---- Science and everyday life. 284p. 21cm. N. Y., Macmillan co., 1940. For biography see Current Biogr., N. Y., 1940, 1: 357-9. For portrait, photograph see coUection in library. ---- & HUXLEY, Julian. Animal biology. xvi, 344p. front, tab. 12? Oxf., Clarendon Press 1927. HALDANE, John Scott, 1860-1936. Ma- terialism. 221p. 8? Lond., Hodder & Stough- ton [1932] ---- The philosophy of a biologist. 2. ed. xiii, 183p. 8? Oxf., Clarendon Press, 1936. For biography see Brit. M. J., 1936, 1: 617-9, portr. Also Canad. M. Ass. J., 1936, 35: 197-98 (A. G. N.) Also J. Am. M. Ass., 1936, 106: 1671. Also Lancet, Lond., 1936, 1: 687, portr. Also Nature, Lond., 1936, 137: 566-9. Also Presse med., 1936, 44: 830 (L. Binet) Also Proc. R. Soc. Edinburgh, 1936-37, 57: 253. Also Rev. Soc. argent, biol., 1936, 12: 15 (J. T. Lewis) For portrait, photograph see coUection in library. Also J. Hyg., Cambr., 1936, 36: front. ----& GRAHAM, Joseph Ivon. Methods of air analysis. 4. ed. vii, 176p. illust. pi. diaers. 8? Lond., C. Griffin & co., 1935. HALDANE, John Scott, 1860- , & PRIESTLEY, John Gillies. Respiration. 2. ed. 3 1. xiip. 493p. illust. pi. diagrs. 8? N. Haven, Yale Univ. Press, 1935. HALDER, Margrit. *Ueber den Einfluss des Ergotamins auf den Grundumsatz Basedow- kranker [Zurich] 21p. 2 tab. 8? Basel, B. Schwabe & co., 1927. AIbo Schweiz. med. Wschr., 1927, 57: HALIBUT . 36 HALL 46.—Thompson, W. F. Conservation of the Pacific hahbut, an international experiment. Annual Rep. Smithson. Inst., 1935, 361-82. HALICYSTIS. Blinks. L. R. Protoplasmic potentials in Halicvstis. J. (Jen. Physiol., 1929-30, 13: 223-9. Also repr.—Osterhout, W. J. V. Calculations of bioelectric potentials; potentials in Hahcystis. Ibid., 1939, 23: 53-7. HALIDE. See Halogen. HALIFAX, Nova Scotia. Nova Scotia Hospi- tal. Annual report. Halifax, 70., 1926-27; 74- 77., 1930-31-1933-24. HALIFAX, Nova Scotia. Nova Scotia Sana- torium. Annual report and medical supplement. Halifax, v.30, 1934- HALIFAX, Nova Scotia. Victoria General Hospital. Annual report. Halifax, 27.-33., 1892-93/1898-99; 61., 1926-27; 64.-68., 1929-30/ 1933-34. HALISTERESIS. See under Osteomalacia. HALITOSIS. See Breath, Fetor. HALIVER oil. See under Halibut. HALKET, George, 1849-1928. Obituary. Brit. M. J., 1928, 2: 775. Also Glasgow M. J. 1928, 110: 283, portr. HALKETT, Samuel, 1814-71, & LAING, John. Dictionary of anonymous and pseudonymous English literature; new ed. by James Kennedy, W. A. Smith, and A. F. Johnson. 6v. roy. 8? Edinb., Oliver & Boyd, 1926-32. HALL, A. L. Injuries of the spine. 5 photogr. 16? [n. p., n. pub.] 1927. HALL, A. Gratten. Doctor Wilfred Grenfell. 64p. 18? Lond., Morgan & Scott [18-?] HALL, Alfred Daniel, 1864- , CROWTHER James Gerald [et al.] The frustration of science. 144p. 8? Lond., G. Allen & Unwin [1935] HALL, Bolton, 1854- Psychology of sleep; with an introduction by Edward Moffat Wever. xiv, 305p. 8? N. Y., Moffat, Yard & Co., 1917. HALL, Byron E[llsworth] 1906- Evalua- tion of the supravital staining method, p. 643- 98. 8? N. Y., P. B. Hoeber, 1938. In Handb. Hemat. (Downey, H.) N. Y., 1938, 1: HALL, Charles A., 1863-1938. Obituary. BuU. Acad. M. Cleveland, 1938, 22: No. 9, 15. HALL, Charles E. Negroes in the United States, 1920-32. xvi, 845p. 4? Wash., U. S Bur. of Census, 1935. HALL, Charlotte. Nature's pyramid to health. 159p. illust. portr. 20cm. [Denver, 1938] HALL, Courtney Robert 1894r- A scien- tist in the early republic; Samuel Latham Mitchill. 1764-1831. vi, 162p. portr. 8? N. Y., Colum- bia Univ. Press, 1934. HALL, Custis Lee, 1888- A fracture of the humerus, probably syphilitic in origin. 5n 8? TWash., n. pub.] 1920. HALL, David G., 1903- New muscoid flies (Diptera) in the United States National Museum, p.201-16. 7 figs. 8? Wash., 1937. Forms No. 3011 v.84, Proc U. S. Nat. Mus. HALL, Edward Parks, 1877-1926. Obituary. J. Am. M. Ass., 1926, 86: 1927. HALL, Frances Adkins. Statistical measure- ment in group work; a manual on statistical records for use by staff members, vi, 103p. 23cm. Wash., Gov. Print. Off., 1939. Forms No. 248, Children's Bur. Pub. HALL, Ffrancis] de Havilland, 1847-1929. Differential diagnosis; a manual of the compara- tive semeiology of the more important diseases. 3. Am. ed. ed. by Frank Woodbury, xi, 255p. 8? Phila., D. G. Brinton, 1887. For biographv see Brit. M. J., 1929, 1: 271; 328. Also Lancet, Lond., 1929. 1: 311. HALL, Frank Gregory, 1896- See Pearse, Arthur Sperry, & Hall, F. G. Homoiothermism. 119p. 8? N. Y., 1928. HALL, G. Norman, 1885- investiga- tions on Rinderpest immunization. 158p. 8? Ziir., H. Roth [1933] HALL, G. Stanley, 1846-1924. Editor of Pedagogical Seminary and Journal of Genetic Psychology. Worcester, Mass., v.1-31, 1891-1924. See also Wilson, L. N. Bibliography of the published writings of President G. Stanley HaU. Pub. Clark Univ. Libr., 1903-5, 1: 3-16. For biography see Rev. med. Barcelona, 1924, 2. ser., 2: 383. HALL, George Clifton, 1867-1925. Righter, F. P. |Obituary] Abstr. Proc. Ass. Life Insur. M. Dir. America, 1924-25, 12: 7. HALL, H. C. *La degenerescence h^pato- lenticulaire (maladie de Wilson—pseudo-sclerose) xi, 361p. 8? Kbh., Levin & Munksgaard, 1921. HALL, H[arry] Newbery. Manual of general pathology and morbid anatomy. 188p. 12? Chic, Rand, McNally & Co., 1891. HALL, Henry Morton, 1870-1926. Obituary. J. Am. M. Ass., 1926, 86: 1088. HALL, Herbert James, 1870-1923, & BUCK, Mertice M. C. Handicrafts for the handi- capped, xiv, 155p. 24 pi. 12? N. Y., Moffat, Yard & Co., 1916. HALL, Ion Simson. Diseases of the nose, throat and ear; a handbook for students and practitioners. xv, 423p. illust. pi. 12? Edinb., E. & S. Livingstone,. 1937. HALL, James Norman, 1887- Doctor Dogbody's leg. 5 p. 1. 371p. illust. pi. 21cm. Bost., Little, Brown & Co., 1940. HALL, John, 1575-1635. Dr John Hall: Shakespeare's son-in-law. Lancet, Lond 1935, 2: 1332-4.—Scarlett, E. P. Shakespeare's son-in-law, Doctor John Hall. Canad. M. Ass. J., 1940, 43: 482-8. HALL, John Basil, 1868-1926. W„W. N. W. Obituary. Brit. M. J., 1926, 1: 169. Also Lancet, Lond., 1926, 1: 206. HALL, John William, 1857-1939. Obituary. S. Afr. M. J., 1939, 13: 614. HALL, Josiah Newhall, 1859-1939. , ^ari"g> J- ■»• Obituary. Ann. Int. M., 1939-40, 13: 1787. Also J. Am. M. Ass., 1939, 113: 2336. HALL, Lewis B. The common sense of keep- ing well; 10 lessons by The Century Club. 227p. 8? Chic. [n. pub.] 1930. P HALL, Lucinda Susannah Capen, 1815-57. Waite, F. C. The first woman to receive a medical degree from a New England Institution. N. England J. M. 1934 210: 644—7. HALL, Lyman, 1724-90. Krafka, J., jr. A Connecticut doctor who mixed medicine and politics in Georgia. Yale J. Biol., 1937-38, 10: 531-7 — Thorns, H. [Biography] Med. J. & Rec, 1927, 125: 808-10. HALL, Marshall, 1790-1857. r ISa,t™l,i& Xi AIarsha11 HaU. In bis Great doctors, Lond., 1935, 85-105. HALL, Maurice C[rowther] 1881-1938. The bedbug; its relation to public health, its habits ond Jife mstory> and methods of control. 7p. 8? Wash., 1937. Forms Suppl. No. 129, Pub. Health Rep. See also Hero (a) of hookworm. Clin. M. & S., 1934 41: HALL 37 HALLBAUR For biography see J. Parasit., Lancaster, 1938, 24: 283- 90. (B. Schwartz, et al.) Also Proc Helminth. Soc. Wash- ington, 1939, 6: 9. HALL, Milton W[eston] 1878- See Siler, J. F., Hall. Milton W., & Hitchens, A. Parker. Dengue, its history [&c] 476p. 8? Manila, 1926. HALL, Pearl Mitchell, 1860-1928. M„J. A. Obituary. Am. Rev. Tuberc, 1929, 19: 230-2, portr. HALL, Percy, 1882- Ultra-violet rays in the treatment and cure of disease; with intro- ductions by Sir Henry Gauvain and Leonard E. Hill. 3. ed. xviii, 236p. front, ch. 8? Lond., W. Heinemann, 1927. Also 4. ed. xviii, 248p. ch. 8? Lond., W. Heinemann, 1929. ---- Asthma and its treatment, ix, 130p. 12? Lond., W. Heinemann, 1930. HALL, P[eter] 1893- *Untersuchung der Sippe eines Recklinghausen-Kranken mit be- sonderer Beriicksichtigung der Genese der ge- fundenen Anomalien und der Frage der Ver- erbung. 58p. 8? Bonn, A. Brand, 1937. HALL, Rufus Bartlett, 1849-1936. Carothers, R. Obituary. Tr. South. Surg. Ass., 1936, 49: 458. HALL, Samuel Warren, 1902- Tangier island; a study of an isolated group, x p. 2 1. 122p. pi. map. 23^cm. Phila., Univ. Penn- sylvania Press, 1939. HALL, Stanley, SANFORD, E. C. [et al.] John Wallace Baird; in memoriam. 62p. 8? Worcester, Mass., 1919. Forms No. 2, v.6, Pub. Clark Univ. Libr., 1919. HALL, W. F., & HALL, Mrs. W. F. Arkansas 1836-1936; a study of its growth and charac- teristics in observance of its centenary year, 1936. 3 1. 48p. 8? Wash., Gov. Print. Off., 1936. Forms Senate Doc. No. 191, 74. Congr., 2d Sess. HALL, William H. Crusader castles of the Near East, p.369-90. 8? Wash., Nat. Geogr. Soc, 1931. HALL, William Thomas, 1874- Editor of Moore, F. J. A history of chemistry. 3. ed. 447p. 21cm. N. Y., 1939. HALL, William W[hitty] 1810-76. Fun better than physic; or, everybody's life-preserver. 333p. portr. 12? Springf., Mass., D. E. Fisk & Co. [1871] HALL, Winfield S[cott] 1861- Biology, physiology and sociology of reproduction, also sexual hygiene with special reference to the male. 138p. 8? Chic, H. A. Ray, 1906. For portrait, photograph, see coUection in Ubrary. HALLAM, Samuel. See Dilling, Walter James, & Hallam, Samuel. Dental materia medica. 328p. 8? Lond., 1936. HALLAND, Herman E. See Rogers, C, & Halland, H. E. Flight surgeon. 295p. 21cm. N. Y., 1940. HALLAUER, Curt, 1900- *Zur Chemie der bakteriellen Toxine [Basel] p. 138-64. 8? Berl., J. Springer, 1925. Also Zschr. Hyg., 1925, 105: See also Handbuch der Virusforschung. 546p. 25cm. Wien, 1938. HALL AY, Leo, 1901- *Eklampsie und Witterung. 51p. 8? [Jena, n. pub.] 1928. HALLBAUER, Hildegard, 1912- *Ver- handlungsfahigkeit bei Diabetes mellitus [Hei- delberg] 12p. 8? Diisseld., G. H. Nolte, 1938. HALLBAUER, Maria, 1912- *Therapie und Erfolge bei Blasenscheidenfisteln an der Frauenklinik der Universitat Heidelberg von 1910-34 [Heidelberg] 27p. 8? Giitersloh, Thiele [1936] HALLBAUR, Friedhilde, 1909- *Derma- titis toxica nach parenteraler Goldgabe [Frei- burg] 23p. 8? Breisach, K. Maier, 1932. ^ HALLE, Bruno Josip Ivan, 1900- *Ueber reversible Hamolyse. 16p. 8? Wiirzb. [n. pub.] 1925. Also Biochem. Zschr., 1925, 160: 199-209. HALLE, Guillaume Paul Marie, 1908- *Peirostite albumineuse; sa localisation a 1'os iliaque. 118p. 2 pi. 8? Par., Jouve & cie, 1937. HALLE, Herbert, 1898- *Zoster und Leukamie nebst Bemerkungen iiber die Provoka- tion leukamischer Infiltrate in der Haut [Bres- lau] p.238-49. 8? Berl., J. Springer, 1929. Also Arch. Derm. Syph., Berl., 1929-30, 159: HALLE, J., ARMAND-DELILLE [et al.] Infections a germe inconnu. viii, 2 p. 1. 383p. 8? Par., A. Maloine & fils, 1921. Forms v. 16, Traite path. med. HALLE, John, 1529-68. Power, D'A. John HaUe; a hater of quacks. In his Mirror for Surgeons, Bost., 1939, 44-51. HALLE, Max, 1873-1939. Obituary. J. Am. M. Ass., 1939, 113: 1826. Also Tr. Am. Acad. Ophth. Otolar., 1939, 414. HALLE, Germ. Amt fiir Wirtschaft, Verkehr und Statistik. Statistische Monatsberichte. Halle, v.27, 1933- HALLE, Germ. Universitat. Hallische Uni- versitatsreden. 2 Nos. 22>^cm. Halle, M. Nie- meyer, 1917-37. CONTENTS No. 4, Technik und Wissenschaft in der Medizin. J. Veit. 1917. 27p. No. 71, Das Problem der Speicherung der mitteldeutschen Eisenerze. J. Weigelt. 1937. 16p. HALLE, Germ. Abderhalden, E. Die Kaiserlich-Leopoldinisch-Carolinische Deutsche Akademie der Naturforscher. Umschau, 1925, 29: 87.—Brugsch, T. Die KUnik in Halle (historisch) Arch. Gesch. Med., 1928, 20: 17-32.—Halle (The) academy, 1652- 1937. Nature, Lond., 1937, 140: 179. HALL-EDWARDS, John Francis, 1858-1926. Cancer; its contro] and prevention (education will lower the death-rate). 5 p. 1. 88p. 12? Birmingham, Cornish bros, 1926. For biography see Brit. J. Radiol., B. I. R. Sect., 1926, 31, 455-9, portr. Also Brit. M. J., 1926, 2: 363. Also Lancet: Lond., 1926, 2: 410. Also Med. J. & Rec, 1926, 124: 367. Also Proc. R. Soc. Edinburgh, 1925-26, 46: 365. HALLEMANN, Ernst, 1912- *Die unter dem Bilde der Hodentumoren auftretenden Formen von Nebenhodentuberkulose. 31p. pi. 23cm. Lpz., A. Teicher, 1937. HALLENBECK, Orlando J., 1854-1930. Obituary. J. Am. M. Ass., 1930, 94: 809. HALLER, Albin, 1849-1925. Ramart, P. Notice sur la vie et les travaux de Albin HaUer. Bull. Soc. chim. France, 1926, 4. ser., 1037-92, portr. HALLER, Albrecht von, 1708-77. Letters to his daughter on the truths of the Christian religion; transl. from German. 2. corr. ed. xxxii, 278p. 8? London, J. Murray, 1793. ---- Von den empfindlichen und reizbaren Teilen des menschlichen Korpers. Deutsch hrsg. und eingeleitet von Karl Sudhoff. 58p. 12? Lpz., J. A. Barth, 1922. Forms Bd 27, Klassiker der Medizin (K. Sudhoff) ---- A dissertation on the sensible and irrit- able parts of animals. 49p. portr. 8? Bait., Johns Hopkins Press, 1936. Reprinted from Bull. Inst. Hist. Med., v.4, No. 8, 1936. For biography see Clin. M. & S., 1933, 40: 243, portr. Also Med. ibera, 1934, 28: p. cclxxix (J. Alvarez-Sierra) For portrait see BuU. Inst. Hist. Med., 1936, 4: 650. See also Doss, I. Das pathologisch-anatomische Werk Albrecht v. HaUers in Gottingen. 35p. 8? G6tt., 1937. HALLER 38 HALLETT *Ileus in der Beziehung zur Also Irsay. S. Albrecht von HaUer; eine Studie zur Geistes- geschichte der Aufklarung. 2 p. 1. 704p 3 pi. 8? Lpz., 1930. Also Biirgi, E. Betrachtungen Uber die \ ielseitigkeit HaUer's. Schweiz. med. Wschr., 1934, 64: 531.—Diepgen, P. Albrecht Haller und die Geschichte der Medizin. In Natur- u. Heilwissensch. (Festgabe G. Sticker) Berl., 1930, 100-11 — Klotz, O. [Biography] Ann. M. Hist., 1936, 8: 10-26 — Le Gendre. P. L'encyclopediste Albert de Haller, envisage comme homme de lettres; poete prerornan tique, moraliste et religieux. Bull. Soc. fr. hist, med., 1931. 25: 326; 381. HALLER, Erich [Gustav Friedrich] 1914- *Milzarterienaneurysma bei Carcinom des Pan- kreas [Tubingen] lip. 21cm. Wiirzb., K. Triltsch, 1937. HALLER, Ernst von 1911- *Der ohne entzundliche Erkrankung entstehende Spontan- pneumothorax. 40p. 23cm. Berl., K. & R. Hoffmann, 1938. HALLER, Erwin, 1912- *Fortsetzung der Statistik iiber besonders kariesanfallige und kariesfreie Gebisse im Hinblick auf die Vererbung. 32p. 8? Tub., A. Becht, 1936. HALLER, Franz, 1910- *Bemerkens- werte Spatbefunde bei schweren Schadelbruchen mit Stirnhirnverletzungen [Munchen] 28p. 8? Bleicherode, C. Nieft, 1936. HALLER, Lore, 1906- *Ein Fall von myotonischer Dystrophie mit Familienforschung. 26p. 8? Tub., E. Gobel, 1933. HALLER, Sylvie, 1911- *Taille et poids du nourrisson. 60p. 25cm. Par., F. Alcan, 1938. HALLER, Wolfgang, 1911- Sohwangerschaft und seine schwangerschaftshormonalen Atonie der Darm und Ureter-Muskulatur [Heidelberg] 13p. 8? Wurzb., K. Triltsch, 1938. HALLERAN, Margaret M. The effect of rickets on the mental development of young children. 67p. 8? N. Y., 1938. Forms No. 229, Arch. Psychol., N. Y. HALLERBACH, Georg, 1894- *Ueber Kapillarveranderungen am Nagelfalz bei Kera- titis parenchymatosa [Frankfurt a. M.] 8p. 8? Berl., S. Karger, 1929. Also Zschr. Augenh., 1928, 67: HALLERMANN, Otto, 1902- *Die chi- rurgische Behandlung der Patellarluxation mit besonderer Beriicksichtigung der Kutisplastik [Freiburg i. B.] 29p. 8? Heidelb., P. Braus, 1928. HALLERMANN, Wilhelm, 1909- *Ueber Anomalien der ersten Rippen [Freiburg i. B.] 32p. 8? Waldkirch i. B. [n. pub., 1935] ---- Der plotzliche Herztod bei Kranzge- fasserkrankungen. vii, 215p. incl. illust. tab. 25cm. Stuttg., F. Enke, 1939. HALLER von HALLERSTEIN, Viktor, 1887- Aussere Gliederung des Zentralnervensys- tems. p. 1-318. illust. roy. 8? Berl., Urban & Schwarzenberg, 1934. In Handb. vergl. Anat. (Bolk, L. [et al.]) Berl., 1934, 2: ---- Kranialnerven. p.541-684. illust. roy. 8? Berl., Urban & Schwarzenberg, 1934. In Handb. vergl. Anat. (Bolk, L. [et al.]) Berl., 1934, 2: HALLERVORDEN, Jfulius] 1882- Die hereditiire Ataxie. p.657-97. 8? Berl., 1936. Handb. Neur. (Bumke & Foerster) Berl., 1936, 16: ---- Die Kleinhirnatrophien. p. 697-728. 8? Berl., 1936. Handb. Neur. (Bumke & Foerster) Berl., 1936, 16: HALLERVORDEN-SPATZ disease. See Nervous system, Disease, congenital. HALLETT, Frederic G., 1860-1933. Cata- logue of portraits and busts in the Royal College of Surgeons of England, with short biographical notices. 96p. pi. portr. 8? [Lond., Taylor & Francis] 1930. For biography see Lancet, Lond., 1933, 1: 336. HALLETT, Winslow N. *A psychophysical study of visual gestalten [Univ. Pennsylvania] p.691-700. 8? Phila. [n. pub.] 1933. HALLEY DES FONTAINES, Jean Charles Louis, 1895- Contribution a l'dtude de l'an- drogynie; la notion d'androgynie dans quelques mythes et quelques rites. 231p. 8? Par., Ed. Hippocrate, 1938. HALLEY Y MIRALLES, Guillermo, 1912- *La dilatation douloureuse du colon droit. 92p. 8? Par., E. Le Francois, 1937. HALLIBURTON, William Dobinson, 1860- 1931. The essentials of chemical physiology. 2. ed. xi, 170p. illust. 8? Lond., Longmans, Green & Co., 1896. Also 7. ed. xi, 280p. illust. 1909. Also 12. ed. with J. A. Hewitt and W. Robson. xii, 383p. 1929. Also 13. ed. with J. A. Hewitt and W. Robson. xii, 350p. illust. pi. tab. diagrs. [1936] See also Contributions to psychiatry, neurology and soci- ology [&c] 401p. roy. 8? Lond., 1929. For biography see Biochem. J., Lond., 1932, 26: 269-71. Also Brit. M. J., 1931, 1: 1006 (F. Hopkins) Also Lancet, Lond., 1931, 1: 1263. Also Proc. R. Soc, Lond., 1932, 109: ser. B, p. ix-xi, portr. (E. S. S.) For portrait, photograph see collection in library. ---- & McDOWALL, Robert John Stewart. Handbook of physiology. 18. ed. xxiii, 902p. 3 pi. 8? Lond., J. Murray [1929] Also 19. ed. xi, 842p. 4 pi. [1930] Also 34. ed. xi, 971p. illust. pi. [1935] Also 35. ed. xi, 973p. illust. 4 col. pi. diagr. 22cm. Phila., P. Blakiston's Sons & Co. [1937] HALLIDAY, Charles H., 1880- Pneu- monic plague; report of an outbreak at Los Angeles, Oct.-Nov., 1924. 12p. ch. 8? Sacra- mento, J. E. King, 1925. Forms Spec. Bull. No. 46, Cabfornia State Bd Health. ---- Plague; a potential hazard during mo- bilization. 33p. pi. 4 maps. tab. ch. 27}4cm. [n. p., n. pub., 1938] HALLIDAY, Nellie, 1889- *Quantitative comparative studies of the adsorption of vitamins B and G from protein-free milk by Lloyd's Reagent [Columbia Univ.] 50p. 8? N. Y. [n. pub.] 1929. HALLIN, Olof Fredrik, 1821- Handbok i helso- och sjukvardslara populart framstald [Handbook of the doctrine of hygiene and of the care of the sick] v.l. Helsolara. hi, 952p. 8? Chic, Swedish Book Co., 1889. HALLION, Louis, 1896-1940. Binet, L. [Necrologie] Presse med., 1940, 48: 630, portr.— Necrologie. BuU. Acad, med., Par., 1940, 3. ser., 123: 311. Also C. rend. Soc. biol., 1940, 133: 613-5. HALLMANN, Charlotte, 1911- *Navi- culare bipartitum manus [Giessen] 12p, 21cm. Glogau [n. pub.] 1938. HALLMANN, Dorothea, 1910- Unter- suchungen uber die Herstellung spezifisch- prazipitierender Immunsera, mit besonderer Beriicksichtigung der Entfernung von heterologen und Verwandtschaftsprazipitinen [Breslau] 30p. 8? Ohlau, H. Eschenhagen, 1933. HALLMANN, Lothar, 1898- *Parenterale Typhusinfektion (klinisch-anatomisch, bakterio- logisch und pathologisch) 17p. 8? Berl., n. pub.] 1930. ---- Klinische Chemie und Mikroskopie; ausgewahlte Untersuchungsmethoden fiir das medizinisch-chemische Laboratorium. viii, 387p too?- C°1- pL diagr' 21^cm- LPZ> G- Thieme, HALLOCK 39 HALLUCINATION HALLOCK, Grace T„ 1893- Dramatiz- ing child health; a new book of health plays, with chapters on the writing, the producing, and the educational value of dramatics, ix, 306p. 8? N. Y., Am. Child Health Ass., 1925. ----& TURNER, C. E. Edward Jenner. 24p. 8? [N. Y., Metropolitan Life Ins. Co., 1926] ---- Edward Livingston Trudeau. vii, 168p. 8? Bost., D. C. Health & co. [1929] ---- Walter Reed. 24p. 8? [N. Y., Metro- politan Life Ins. Co., 1926] See also Turner, Clair Elsmere, & Hallock, Grace T. The voyage of growing up. 204p. 8°. Bost. [1935] HALLOCK, Frank Kirkwood, 1860-1937. McKendree, C. A. Obituary. Tr. Am. Neur. Ass., 1937, 63: 191.—Obituary. J. Nerv. Ment. Dis., 1937, 86: 507. HALLOIN, Joseph Emil, 1897- *Appen- dicitis in children under 5 years [St Elizabeth's Hospital] 11 1. 4? Appleton, Wis., 1928. Typewritten. HALLOPEAU, Henri, 1842-1919. Beeson, B. B. [Biography] Arch. Derm. Syph., Chic, 1931, 23: 730-2. HALLOPEAU'S DISEASE. See Acrodermatitis. HALLORAN, Florence John, 1859-1935. [Obituary] Minnesota Med., 1935, 18: 170. HALLORAN, Paul Stacey, 1874-1931. Cooper, A. T. [Obituary] MU. Surgeon, 1931, 68: 835-7. HALLOT, Guy, 1903- *Prophylaxie de la peste par la surveillance des rats. 62p. 8? Par., Jouve & cie, 1930. HALLOWAY, Thomas Beaver, 1872-1936. McGuire, H. H. Obituary. Tr. Am. Ophth. Soc, 1937, 37: 18-23, portr. HALLUCINATION. See also Hallucinosis; also Apparition; Auto- matism; Clairvoyance; Delirious states; Dream; Dream states; Epilepsy, psychic, &c; also names of primary diseases; also Illusion; Per- ception, abnormal. Qtjercy, P. Les hallucinations. 147p. 12? Par., 1936. . . Specht, W. Wahrnehmung und Halluzination. 147p. 8? Lpz., 1914. Bender, L., & Lipkowitz, H. H. Hallucinations in children. Am. J. Orthopsychiat,., 1940, 10: 471-90.—Bouyer, H. Notes pour servir d'introduction a l'etude positive des hallucinations. Ann. med. psychol., Par., 1926, 84: pt 2, 432-46.-Buentello y Villa, E. El concepto de alucinaci6n. Medicina, Mex., 1933, 13: 525; 1934, 14: 7; 112.—Campbell, C. M. Hallucinations; their nature and significance. Am. J. Psychiat., 1929-30, 9: 607-18.—Capgras, J., & Nodet, C. H. Hallucinations psy- chique a localisation auriculaire unilaterale. Ann. med. psychol., Par., 1937, 95: 421-6.—Claude, H., & Ey, H. Hallu- cinations, pseudo-hallucinations et obsessions. Ibid., 1932, 90: pt 2 273-316 —Davidson, H. A. Hallucinations. In Cyclop. Med. (Piersol-Bortz) Phila., 1939, 6: 922-4.—Fletcher, D. R. HaUucinations. Ontario J. Neuropsychiat., 1928, 60-4.— Forster, E. Ueber normale und pathologische Reaktionsformen (HaUuzinationen) Mschr. Psychiat., 1928, 68: 201-16.— Galant, J. S. Ueber Autohalluzinationen (vorlaufige Mittei- lung) Zschr. ges. Neur. Psychiat., 1929,120: 585—Gorriti, F Alucinaciones de presencia exterior invisible. Rev. As. med. argent., 1936, 50: 1919-24. Also Sem. med., B. Air., 1936, 43: pt 2 324-6.—Guiraud, P. Representation et haUucination. Paris med., 1932, 85: 120-8.— Hall, J. K. On the meaning of hallucinations. West Virginia M. J., 1935, 31: 306-10.— Hallucinations. Lancet, Lond., 1941. 1: 421.—Ives, R. L. You don't have to believe it. Science News Lett., 1938, 33: 214 —Klein, R. Ueber HaUuzinationen der Korpervergrosse- run'g. Mschr. Psychiat,, 1928, 67: 78-85.—Kreibig, J. C. Ueber den Begriff Sinnestauschung. C. rend. Congr. internat. psychol. (1900) 1901, 4. Congr., 232— Lang, J. The other side of haUucinations. Am. J. Psychiat., 1937-38, 94: 1089-97.- Liegeois, J. Les haUucinations negatives et la psychologie experimentale. C. rend. Congr. internat. psychol. (1900) 1901, 4. Congr., 697.—McCowan, P. K. The significance of auditory and visual hallucinations. Brit. M. J., 1939, 2: 631-4. ------ Critchley, MacD. [et al.] Significance of auditory and visual hallucinations. Lancet, Lond., 1939, 2: 426.—Mayer-Gross. W. Ueber HaUuzinationen. Nervenarzt, 1931, 4: 1-12.—Meerloo, A. M. [Hallucinations] Ned. tschr. geneesk., 1934, 78: 4542-8—Myslivecek, Z. [Study of hallu- cinations] Rev. neur. psychiat., Praha, 1929, 26: 270-80.— Palmer, H. M. Of hallucinations. Lancet, Lond., 1928, 1: 1277.-—Revault d'Allonnes. L'hallucination. Ann. med. psychol., Par., 1926, 84: 43-55.—Roberti, C. E., & Fiore, G. DeUe pllucinazioni. Rass. stud, psichiat., 1936, 25: 3; 151; 312; 1937, 26: 245; 353; 623.—Schroder, P. Das Halluzinieren. Zschr. ges. Neur. Psychiat., 1926, 101: 599-614. Also Nerven- arzt, 1933, 6: 561-6.—Seglas, J. Sur les phenomenes dits hallucinations psychiques. C. rend. Congr. internat. psychol. (1900) 1901, 4. Congr., 553-9.—Sollier. Autoscopie interne v6rifi§e expfirimentalement. J. psychol. norm, path., Par., 1908, 5: 354-8.—Tarchanoff, J. de. Sur les illusions et les haUucinations des grenouilles. C. rend. Congr. internat. psychol. (1900) 1901, 4. Congr., 89-92.—Toninelli, C. C. In tema di aUucinazioni. Osp. maggiore Novara, 1936, 13: 407-12.—Vedrani. A. Alucinor, alucinatus sum, alucinari. Rass. stud, psichiat,, 1926, 15: 549-56.—Williams, C. L., Williams, P. D., & Jewell, E. B. Case report. J. Indiana M. Ass., 1940, 33: 626-8.—Wood, E. G. Experiences in a house. Proc Am. Soc. Psychic. Res., 1920, 14: 360-418.—Ziegler, L. H. Entertaining hallucinations not interfering with use- fulness. Med. Clin. N. America, 1930, 13: 1367.—Zsako, L, & Jo, J. [Hallucinations] Budapesti orv. ujs., 1933, 31: 753-5. ---- auditory. Osann, E. G. R. H. *Ueber Gehorshallucina- tionen bei Ohrenaffektionen. 45p. 8? Lpz., 1902. Balzano, I. AUucinazione acustica da tappo di cerume (contributo clinico) Rass. ital. otorinolar., 1927, 1: 26-30.— Banyai & Matulay. [Auditory hallucinations and otologic findings] Bratisl. lek. Usty, 1936, 16: Suppl., 289-92.— Berggren, S. Die Beziehungen zwischen Gehorhalluzinationen und Gehororgan. Arch. Ohr. &c. Heilk., 1929, 120: 141-63.— Bosch, G., & Gorriti, F. NouveUe forme d'hallucination auditive verbale. Ann. m6d. psvchol., Par., 1932, 90: pt 2, 439-46. Also Arch, argent, neur., 1931-32, 7: 75-83. Also Rev. As. med. argent., 1932, 45: 838. Also Sem. med., B. Air., 1932. 39: pt 2, 442.—Childers, A. T. Auditory hallucinations in problem children. Ohio M. J., 1934, 30: 299-303.—Condo- mine, A., & Beaujard, M. La force determinante des haUucina- tions auditives. Progr. med., Par., 1936, 345-50.—Ey. H. Les hallucinations psycho-motrices verbales et le probleme general des hallucinations. C. rend. Congr. alien, neur. France, 1934, 38. Congr., 273-9.—Guiraud, P., & Lagache, D. Du role de l'erethisme moteur primitif dans la genese des hallucina- tions parlees. Ann. med. psychol., Par., 1934, 92: 69-74.— Levin, M. Auditory haUucinations in non-psychotic children. Am. J. Psychiat., 1932, 11: 1119-52.—Logre, B. J., & Lagache, D. HaUucinations verbales et respiration. Ann. med. psychol., Par., 1933, 91: 166-74.—Morel, F. Examen audiom.6trique de malades pr6sentant des hallucinations auditives verbales. Ibid., 1936, 94: 520-33. ------ L'echo de la lecture; con- tribution k l'etude des hallucinations auditives verbales. Encephale, 1933, 28: 169-83.—Murakami, M. Ueber die eigenartige GehorshaUuzination bei einem Schizophrenen. Psychiat. neur. jap., 1940, 44: 24.—Nouet, H., & Lautier, J. HaUucinations auditives conscientes de longue duree. Ann. med. psychol., Par., 1927, 85: 146-51—Parker, S., & Schilder, P. Acoustic imagination and acoustic hallucination. Arch. Neur. Psychiat., Chic, 1935, 34: 744-57.—Quercy, P. Travaux recents sur les haUucinations motrices verbales. Encephale, 1935, 30: 97-125.—Semrad, E. V. Study of the auditory apparatus in patients experiencing auditory hallucinations. Am. J. Psychiat., 1938-39, 95: 53-63.—Vivaldo, J. C., & Barrancos, A. El tratamiento de las alucinaciones auditivas, por las sales de quinina, suUato de quinina. Prensa med. argent., 1940, 27: 512-7. ------ Consideraciones sobre las alucinaciones auditivas y la acci6n terapeutica de las sales de quinina Ibid., 938-44.—Vujic, V. Halluzinatorisch.es Farben- horen. Jahrb. Psychiat. Neur., 1928-29, 46: 262-6. ---- Etiology. For posthypnotic hallucinations see Hypnosis. Schilder, P. Wahn und Erkenntnis. 115p. 8? Berl., 1918. Baruk, H., & Racine, M. Bloc septo-ventriculaire gauche dans un cas d'hallucinations psychiques avec troubles de la contention de la pensee interieure. Ann. med. psychol., Par., 1939 97-418-24.—Benon, R. Nervosite infantile et haUucina- tions. Arch. med. enf., 1934, 37: 398-403.—Bouyer. H. L'etat mental des hallucines et ses 2 facteurs. Encephale, 1927 22- 444-56.—Bresowsky. Ueber psychogene HaUuzina- tionen. Mschr. Psychiat., 1926-27, 62: 31-45.—Capelli, J. F. Alucinaci6n y constituci6n. Sem. med., B. Air., 1941, 48: 1144-7.—Cerletti, V. Sulle aUucinazioni sperimentali negli animali e sulla diagnosi di allucinazione neU'uomo. Atti Soc. lombard. sc. med., 1924, 13: 443-8.—David, M., & Puech, P Hallucinations et meningiomes de la petite aile du sphe- noide. Encephale, 1932, 27: 409-21, 2 pi.—Diakova, V. A., & Zalkind, E. M. [HaUucinations in affections of the peripheral, receptor organs] Nevropat. psikhiat., 1936, 5: 47-56.— Flades, C. HaUucinations identiques produites chez la meme HALLUCINATION 40 HALLUCINATION malade par 3 intoxications differentes. Strasbourg m6d., 1934, 94: 47.— (Person, W. Sinnestauschungen bei einem jugend- lichen Ps\ .-hnpathen. Arch. Psychiat., Berl., 1935, 103: 148-58- liahhinc. J. B. S. LTeber HaUuzinationen infolge von Aenderui rm ,1,- Kohh-nsiiuredrucks. Tsychol. Forsch., 1924, 5: 356. Hill. J. M. Hallucinations in psychoses. J. Nerv. Ment. 1>K. 1936, 83: 405-21.—Lafora, G. R. Alucinaciones auditivab unilaterales y alucinaciones visuales hemian6psicas de origen cortical cerebral. Siglo med., 1926, 77: 390 — Levy-Darras. De la pathogenie des hallucinations. Prat. m6d. fr., 1927, 6: 311-21.—Lhermitte, J., Delthil & Garnier. Syndrome contro-lateral du noyau rouge avec hallucinations visueUes et auditives. Rev. neur., Par., 1938, 70: 623-8.— Lundholm, H. An experimental study of haUucinations. J. Nerv. Ment. Dis., 1927, 66: 60-3. ------ A hormic theory of hallucinations. Brit. J. M. Psychol., 1932, 11: 269-82 — Nolan, M. J. Hallucinations and sanity. J. Ment. Sc, Lond., 1928, 74: 49-58.—Nyiro, J. Endogene und exogene HaUuzina- tionen. Psychiat. neur. Wschr., 1932, 34: 327.—Riser & Ducoudray. Des haUucinations dans l'hypertension cranienne. C. rend. Congr. alien, neur. France, 1935, 39. Congr., 427-30 — Ronchevsky, S. P., & Skalskaia, V. V. [Experimental-clinical data on hallucinations] Sovet. nevropat., 1935, 4: J\b. 5, 10-22.—Ronge, P. H. [Nervous hallucinations] Geneesk. gids. 1931, 9: 77-83.—Schalabutow, K. Zur Pathogenese der HaUuzinationen. Arch. Psychiat., Berl., 1928, 83: 257-63.— Schilder, P. Experiments on imagination, after-images and hallucinations. Am. J. Psychiat., 1933, 13: 597-611.—Simon, T. Sur la pathogenie des hallucinations. Ann. med. psychol., Par., 1937, 95: pt 2, 93-109.—Valkenburg, C. T. van [Senses, brain and hallucination] Ned. tschr. geneesk., 1935, 79: 1913-20. ---- haptic. Lhermitte, J., & Ajuriaguerra. Asymbolie tactile et hallu- cinations du toucher; etude anatomo-clinique. Rev. neur., Par., 1938, 70: 492-5.—Meltzer, D. A. [Kinesthetic hallu- cinations in organic diseases of the brain] Tr. obsh. nevropat. Saratov., 1927, 1: 58-72.— Ravkin, I. G. [On a particular form of complicated tactile-kinesthetic hallucinations (stere- ognostic haUucinations)] Nevropat. psikhiat., 1940, 9: No. 12, 14-24.—Zsako, I. [Hallucinations of haptationj Budapesti orv. ujs., 1936, 34: 457-9. ---- hypnagogic. See also Dream; Sleep. Jequier, M. Hallucinations hvpnagogiques. Rev. m6d. Suisse rom., 1940, 60: 530-9.—Lhermitte, J. Les hallucina- tions et le reve; etude cbnique et pathologique. Gaz. hop., 1933, 106: 1765-7. ---- Mechanism. 1: 575-8. Psico-fisiogenosis del fen6meno alucinatorio. Ferreira Fronteira, F. A. *Algumas palavras sobre as allucinacoes e suas theorias. 77p. 8? Lisb., 1865. Lelong, P. *Le probleme des hallucinations. 103p. 8? Par., 1928. Motjrgue, R. Neurobiologie de 1'hallucina- tion; essai sur une variety particuliere de disinte- gration de la fonction. 416p. 8? Brux., 1932. Schorsch, G. Zur Theorie der HaUuzina- tionen. 84p. 8? Lpz., 1934. Abely, X. Le sentiment de non creation personneUe chez l'hallucine. Ann. med. psychol., Par., 1937, 95: pt 2, 495-508.— Agadjanian, K. Introduction k l'etude experimentale du probltaie de rhallucination. Arch, internat. neur., Par., 1939, 58: 176; 199; 223; 1940, 59: 11.—Beltran, J. R. Psicologia de la alucinacion. Sem. med., B. Air., 1941, 48: 761-6.—Boschi, G. Vedute sulle aUucinazioni desunte daUe aUucinazioni cenestesiche e dalle paracenestesie. Gior. psichiat., 1933, 61- 218-21. ------Mouchet, E., & Alberti, J. L. Alucinacion y percepci6n. Prensa med. argent., 1931-32, 18: 1077-9.—Boss, M. HaUuzinationen in statu nascendi. Schweiz. Arch. Neur Psychiat., 1933, 32: 335-8.—Bourguignon, G. Chronaxies vestibulaires et chronaxies optiques dans 2 cas d'hallucinations auditives et un cas d'hallucinations visuelles. Ann. med psychol., Par., 1936, 94: 637-45.—Brown, L. M. The hallucina- tion as a true sensory phenomenon. Med. BuU. Veterans Admin., 1934-35. 11: 312-7.—Claude, H. Mecanisme des haUucinations. Sem. hop. Paris, 1926, 3: 170-4. ------ Mecanisme des hallucinations; syndrome d'action exterieure Encephale, 1930, 25: 345-59. Also Psychiat. Q., 1930, 4: 59-73. ------ & Ey, H. Evolution des idees sur 1'haUucina- tion; position actueUe du problc'me. Encephale, 1932, 27: 361-77.—Courbon, P. Hen'rogi'neite du comportement haUu- cinatoire. Ann. med. psychol., Par., 1937, 35: 792-7.— Critchley, M. Neurological aspect of visual and auditory hallucinations. Brit. M. J., 1939, 2: 634-9— Dretler, J. Des relations entre la croyance de l'hallucine et sa conviction de l'universalite des hallucinations. Encephale, 1934, 29: 381- 95.—Estape. J. M. La ley de la exteriorizaci6n del pensamiento y el mecanismo de la alucinaci6n. Bev. m6d. lat. amer., B. Air., 1930-31, 16: 301-5. Also Rev. sudamer. med., Par., 1930, Dia med. urug., 1935, 3: 504-6.—Ey, H. La croyance de l'haUucinfi (k propos des etudes de M. Quercv sur rhallucina- tion) Ann. med. psychol., Par., 1932, 90: pt 2. 13-37. —— Quelques aspects generaux du probleme des hallucinations. Schweiz. Arch. Neur. Psychiat., 1933, 32: 269-93. ------ La discussion de 1855-56 a la Societe medico-psychologique sur 1'hallucination et l'etat acttiel du probleme de l'activite hallu- cinatoire. Ann. med. psychol., Par., 1935, 93: 584-613.— Flournoy, H. Le probleme des haUucinations au point de vue psychanalytique. Schweiz. Arch. Neur. Psychiat., 1933, 32: 294-309.—Gozzano, M. II problema delle aUucinazioni all'Xl Congresso internazionale di psicologia. Riv. neur., 1938, 11: 166-78.—Guiraud, P. Apercu sur l'fitat actuel du probleme des hallucinations. Ann. m6d. psychol., Par., 1937, 95: 475- 83. ------ La theorie des 6crans sensoriels et 1'hallucination. Ibid., 618-26.—Hiiter, P. Das Halluzinationsproblem in der deutschen Literatur seit Jaspers. Psychiat. neur. Wschr., 1929, 31: 635; 649.—Janet, P. Les crovances et les hallucinations. Rev. philos. France, 1932, 113: 279-331. ------ Le langage interieur dans rhallucination psychique. Ann. m6d. psychol., Par., 1936, 94: 377-86.—Jonge, A. J. de. Energie psychique et hallucinations. Schweiz. Arch. Neur. Psychiat., 1933, 32: 338-46.—Klimes, K. [Pathopsychology of illusions and halluci- nations] Orv. hetil., 1937, 81: 913-6.—Lafora, G. R. El mecanismo genetico de las alucinationes. Arch, neurob., Madr., 1926, 6: 46-66. ——— Sobre el problema psicol6gico de las alucinaciones. Siglo m6d., 1926, 77: 488.—Lang, J. The other side of hallucinations; interpretation. Am. J. Psychiat., 1939-40, 96: 423-30.—Le Grand, A. Considerations sur le mecanisme des ph6nomenes hallucinatoires; k propos d'un cas d'hallucinations conscientes. J. sc. med. LUle, 1928, 46: pt 2, 121-5.—Ley, A. Le probleme de rhallucination. Fol. neuro- path, eston., 1936, 15:-16: 72.—Leyritz. Note au sujet du langage interieur et de ses hallucinations. Ann. med. psychol., Par., 1927, 75: 481-5.—Maier, H. W. Le probleme des hallu- cinations. Schweiz. Arch. Neur. Psychiat., 1933, 32: 259- 385.—Meerloo, A. M. Ueber das Halluzinieren. Zschr. ges. Neur. Psychiat., 1935, 152: 301-9.—Miller, E. The affective nature of illusion and hallucination. J. Neur. Psvchopath., Brist., 1927-28, 8: 1-8.—Minkowski, E. A propos du probleme des hallucinations. Ann. med. psychol., Par., 1937, 95: 608- 14.—Miskolczy, D. Beitrage zur Halluzinationsfrage. Mschr. Psychiat., 1928, 70: 129-46.—Montet, C. de. L'hallucination et le reel. Schweiz. Arch. Neur. Psychiat., 1933, 32: 346-51.— Morsier, G. de. Le mecanisme des hallucinations. Ann. med. psychol., Par., 1930, 88: pt 2, 365-89. ------ Les hallucina- tions; etude oto-neuro-ophtalmologique. Rev. otoneur., Par., 1938, 16: 244-352 [Discussion] 1939, 17: 185-240. ------ Le aUucinazioni; studio oto-neuro-oftalmologico. Riv. otoneur., 1939, 16: 140-69.—Niessl von Mayendorf. Ueber den vaso- motoriscben Mechanismus der HaUuzinationen. Zschr. ges. Neur. Psychiat., 1928, 114: 311-22.------Ueber eine neurobiologische Deutung der HaUuzination. AUg. Zschr. Psychiat., 1933, 99: 432-7.—Padovani. G. Una vecchia teoria sulle aUucinazioni, in una polemica psichiatrico-drammatica di 60 anni fa. Rass. stud, psichiat., 1938, 27: 897-902.—Perel- muter, E. A. [Analysis of certain forms of hallucinations] Sovet. psikhonevr., 1937, 13: 80-4.—Prince, M. An experi- mental study of the mechanism of hallucinations. In his Clin. Exp. Stud. Person., 2. ed., Cambr., 1939, 424-76.—Problema (II) delle aUucinazioni al Congresso internazionale di psicologia, Parigi, lugho 1937; verbale delle sesta Commissione. Riv. sper. freniat., 1938, 62: 241-8.—Rieti, E. Sul meccanismo psico- genetico delle aUucinazioni. Arch. ital. psicol., 1935-36, 13: 25-38.—Romero, A. Sul problema delle aUucinazioni. Riv. pat. nerv., 1938, 52: 17-66.—Ronchevsky, S. P. [The theory of haUucinations] Nevropat. psikhiat., 1941, 10: No. 3, 53-8.— Sacristan, J. M. Sobre un proceso alucinatorio reflejo. Arch. neurob., Madr., 1924, 4: 118-38.—Salkind, I. A. [Pre-thresh- old haUucinations] Sovet. nevropat., 1935, 4: No. 8, 15-8.— Schroder, P. Sinnestauschungen und Hirnlokalisation. Klin Wschr., 1936, 15: 1345-8. Also Zschr. ges. Neur. Psychiat., 1937, 158: 261-4.—Sommer. W. Zur Lehre von den HaUuzi- nationen. Jahrkurs. iirztl. Fortbild., 1933, 24: 38-42.—Vi6, J. Sur la nature de la certitude hallucinatoire et l'etude analytique des haUucinations. Ann. med. psychol., Par., 1937, 95: 614-8. ---- olfactory. Bromberg W., & Schilder, P. Olfactory imagination and oltactory hallucinations; an experimental and cUnical study of the sense of smell in normal and in psychotic persons. Arch. Neur. Psychiat Chic, 1934, 32: 467-92.—Davidson, G. M. o.?onC™nm£ ha.u,lcinations of smell. Psychiat. Q., 1938 12: ih^nZ^ArpmT' ?■ L" \caf? of factory hallucination in a hypochondriacal prisoner. J. Abnorm. Psychol., 1934-35, 29: t?™r%? ?chteT~£an%' M," oDeux observations d'hallucina- tions olfactives. Cervello, 1938, 17: 280-4 — Schmalfuss H & Barthmeyer Helene. Ueber das Erlebnis'eines Geruc"' wie Phenyl-acetaldehyd, nach Niesen oder Anpral1 de■ I'tira Zschr. Psychol. Sinnesorg., 2. Abt., 1932, 63: 185-7. ---- visual. SchSTe^^ jsszsr. rater xtoaCinualaMsex Yoili V B; 32,-Barnk. H. Les haUucinatic^ ^ueUe^Arch" opht" HALLUCINATION 41 HALLUCINATION Par., 1937, n. ser., 1: 329. Also Bull. Soc. opht. Paris, 1936. 713-39/—Brochado, A. Le svndrome de Capgras. Ann. m£d. psychol., Par., 1936, 94: 706-17.—Chevalier, J., & Bouyer, H. De l'image k 1'haUucination; comment se perd le sens du reel. J. psychol. norm, path., Par., 1926, 23: 439-55.—Daumezon. Hallucinations visuelles, conscientes et transitoires. Ann. m6d. psychol., Par., 1936, 94: 257-62.—Due, C. Sulle aUucinazioni visive. Osp. maggiore Novara, 1936, 13: 43-52.—Ewald, G. Zur Frage des optischen Halluzinierens. Arch. Psychiat., Berl., 1935, 103: 136-47.—Gorriti, F. Alucinaciones-imagenes visuales, conscientes, provocadas, concomitantes y transitorias. Sem. med., B. Air., 1936, 43: pt 2, 1478-80.—Hauptmann, A. Zur Frage der HaUuzinationen im hemianopsichen Gesichts- feld. Zschr. ges. Neur. Psychiat., 1930-31, 131: 90-104 — Hoeven, J. van der [Visions of a fever patient] Bijdr. gesch. geneesk., 1929, 9: 123, pi.—Hoff, H. Zur Frage der formalen Gestaltung optischer HaUuzinationen im hemianopischen Gesichtsfeld. Zschr. ges. Neur. Psychiat., 1931, 137: 453-7. ------ & Potzl, O. Ueber Polyopie und gerichtete hemiano- pische HaUuzinationen. Jahrb. Psychiat. Neur., 1937, 54: 55-88.-—Janbon, M., & Viallefont, H. Hallucinose dans un hemichamp visuel par spasme de la svlvienne. Rev. otoneur., Par., 1931, 9: 94-100.—Johnson, T. H. Visual haUucinations accompanying organic lesions of the brain, with special refer- ence to their value as localizing phenomena. Tr. Am. Ophth. Soc, 1933, 31: 344-94.—Klein, R. Ueber einen Fall von gerich- teter optischer HaUuzinationmitFusionsstorungdeshalluzinier- tenRaumes. Zschr. ges. Neur. Psychiat., 1926, 104: 449-52. ------ Beitrag zur Frage der hemianopischen HaUuzinationen. Mschr. Psychiat., 1935-36, 92: 131-49.------& Stein, R. Ueber hemianopische HaUuzinationen. Klin. Mbl. Augenh., 1933, 91: 805-10.—Lafora, G. R. Las alucinaciones visuales experimentales en los animales y en el hombre. Siglo m£d., 1926, 77: 309.—Lhermitte, J. Les hallucinations visuelles au cours des syndromes pedonculaires. Ann. m6d. psychol., Par., 1934, 92: pt 2, 556-69. ------& de Ajuriaguerra, J. Halluci- nations visuelles et lesions de l'appareil visuel. Ibid., 1936, 94: 321-51. ------ Etude chnqiue et pathogenique des hallucina- tions chez les ophtalmopathes. Ibid., 232-6.—Lhermitte, J., & Bineau, R. Les hallucinations visueUes consecutives aux lesions pedonculaires en foyer. Rev. neur., Par., 1937, 68: 827-31. ------ HaUucinations et fonctions vestibulaires. Rev. otoneur., Par., 1939, 17: 241-4.—Lobova, L. P. [Signifi- cance of the vestibular system in the genesis and structure of the visual haUucinations] Nevropat. psikhiat., 1937, 6: 50- 60.—Morel, F. Hallucination et champ visuel; de la texture, de la forme, de la multipUcite\ des mouvements que pr6sentent les hallucinations visuelles du delirium tremens. Ann. m6d. psychol., Par., 1937, 95: pt 2, 742-57. ------ Hallucinations visueUes monoculaires dans l'aire d'un scotome central avec lesion maculaire correspondante. Rev. otoneur., Par., 1937, 15: 39—41. —Morsier, G. de. lies automatismes visuels (haUu- cinations visuelles retro-chiasmatiques) Schweiz. med. Wschr., 1936, 66: 700-3. ------ HaUucinations monoculaires avec scotome positif au cours d'une nevraxite subaigue. Rev. otoneur., Par., 1938, 16: 120-2.—NiessI von Mayendorf. Ueber die hirnpathologischen Grundlagen der optischen HaUu- zinationen. Arch. ges. Psychol., 1936, 97:132-49.—Noiszewski C. Les projections corticales de la retine et haUucinations visueUes vraies et les pseudohaUucinations. Tr. Internat. Ophth. Congr. (1929) 1930, 13. Congr., 1: 330-2. Also Abstr.— Pear, T. H. Recent investigations on visual imagery, with special reference to hallucinations. J. Ment. Sc, Lond., 1927, 73: 195-9.—[Pierson, J.] Externalized images. J. Am. Soc. Psvchic. Res., 1941, 35: 49-54.—Prince, M. An experimental study of visions. In his Chn. Exp. Stud. Person., 2. ed., Cambr., 1939,373-92. ------ Coconscious images. Ibid., 393-423.— Quercy, P. Auto-observation d'hallucinations visueUes. J. psychol. norm, path., Par., 1927, 24: 520-37. ------ Sur un mecanisme des visions mystiques (1'haUucinationmetasthesique) Ann. med. psychol., Par., 1935, 93: pt 2, 546-55.—Ronchevsky, S. P. [Visual hallucinations in relation to local affections of the sensory apparatus] Sovet. nevropat., 1933, 2: 38-56.— Sacristan, J. M. Para la casufstica de las alucinaciones de la vision del movimiento. Arch, neurob., Madr., 1924, 4: 208- 14.—Sal y Rosas, F. Fantopsias en un caso de ceguera por infection tuberculosa de los ojos. Rev. med. peru., 1940, 12: 59-66.—Seeing things, presentation of a case. N. England J. M., 1940, 222: 1090-3.—Strieff, J. Zum Wesen der entoptischn und haUuzinatorischen Erscheinungen bei intraokularen patho- logischen Zustanden. Klin. Mbl. Augenh., 1936, 97: 229-36 — Terson, A. HaUucinations visuelles chez des ophtalmopathes. Ann. ocul., Par., 1930, 167: 815-25.—True, H. Phantopsies oculaires. Rev. otoneur., Par., 1928, 6: 665-7.—Weinberger, L. M., & Grant, F. C. Visual haUucinations and their neuro- optical correlates. Arch. Ophth., Chic, 1940, 23: 166-99. ---- visual, micropsic. See also Micropsia. Alexander, M. C. LilUputian haUucinations. J. Ment. Sc, Lond., 1926, 72: 187-91.—Laignel-Lavastine & Mignot, H. Scotome avec hallucinations lilliputiennes d'origine epileptique. Ann. med. psychol., Par., 1938, 96: 491-4.—Leroy, R. The affective states in Lilliputian hallucinations. J. Ment. Sc, Lond., 1926, 72: 179-86.—Morsier, G. de. Le syndrome vesti- bulo-visuel parietal d'origine traumatique; contribution a l'etude des centres vestibulaires corticaux et des haUucinations lilliputiennes. Encephale, 1938, 33: 57-72, pi.—Padovani, G. Le aUucinazioni liUipuziane. Rass. stud, psichiat., 1938, 27: 979-1006.—Thomas, C. J., & Fleming, G. W. T. H. LUliputian and brodbingnagian hallucinations occurring simultaneously in a senile patient. J. Ment. Sc, Lond., 1934, 80: 94-102.— Trenel. Hallucinations lilliputiennes exhypnagoguiques. Bull. Soc. cUn. med. ment., Par., 1926, 14: 43-5.—Van Bogaert, L. Sur les haUucinations visuelles au cours des affections organiques du cerveau; contribution a l'6tude du syndrome des hallucina- tions lilliputiennes. Encephale, 1926, 21: 657-79, 5 pi.— Viziolo, F. Contributo alio studio deUe aUucinazioni liUipuziane. Neurologica, Nap., 1926, 3: 11-27.—Yde, A. [LiUiputian hallucinations] Hospitalstidende, 1937, 80: 1004-11.—Zsako, I. [Micropsic hallucinations] Gy6gyiiszat, 1931, 71: 389-91. ------ & Fiirstner, G. Mikropsische HaUuzinationen. Psy- chiat. neur. Wschr., 1932, 34: 289-93. HALLUCINOSIS. See also Delirium tremens; Delusional states; Obsession, &c. Alliez, J. Hallucinose auditive. Rev. otoneur., Par., 1938, 16: 42-5.—Anglade. Otopathie, visiopathie et haUucinose. J. med. Bordeaux, 1939, 116: pt 2, 191.—Barbe & de Laulerie. Troubles sensoriels multiples et hallucinations psycho-mot rices sans affaibUssement inteUectuel, chez un homme de 70 ans. J. psychol. norm, path., Par., 1921, 18: 526-8.—Borel & Ey, H. Obsession hallucinatoire zoopathique gu6rie par psychotherapie. Ann. med. psychol., Par., 1932, 90: pt 2, 181.—Claude, H. Varietes et valeur semiologique du syndrome dit haUucinatoire. Progr. m6d., Par., 1933, 1993-7. ------ Remarques sur les 6tats dits haUucinatoires et leurs rapports avec le fond mental du sujet. Ibid., 1935, 954-8.------Les varietes du syndrome dit haUucinatoire. Schweiz. Arch. Neur. Psychiat., 19*33, 32: 309-14. ------ & Ey, 11. Hallucinose et haUucination; les theories neurologiques; ^cm Konigsb. i. Pr., 1937. Hennemann, F. *Der Hallux rigidus unter besonderer Beriicksichtigung seines Vorkommens im jugendlichen Alter [Heidelberg] 17p. 21cm. Wiirzb., 1938. Honig, J. *Studie iiber die Langenverhaltnisse der Metatarsalia I und II bei Hallux rigidus und Hallux valgus. 23p. 23cm. Zur., 1938. Cochrane, W. A. An operation for haUux rigidus. Brit. M. J., 1927, 1: 1095.—Dieterich, H. Die Beugekontraktur der grossen Zehe. Deut. Zschr. Chir., 1928-29, 213c 127-32.— Faber, A. Die Bedeutung der Versteifung des Grosszehen- grundgelenks in der Unfallbegutachtung. Arch, orthop. UnfaUchir., 1934-35, 35: 640-3.—Finochietto, R. Hallux flexus parahtico. Rev. cirug., B. Air., 1929, 8: 216-25.—Flossbach. Hallux rigidus und seine unfallchirurgische Bedeutung. Med. KUn., Berl., 1930, 26: 389.—Gottlieb, A. Flexion contracture of the big toe after prolonged immobilization. J. Nat. Ass. Chiropod., 1931, 21: No. 6, 5-7. ------ HaUux rigidus. Med. Times, N. Y., 1940, 68: 546-8. Also J. Nat. Ass. Chiropod., 1941, 31: No. 4, 14-7.—Holtje, K. Ueber den HaUux rigidus. Arch, orthop. UnfaUchir., 1938, 39: 375-99—Hutchinson, J., jr. A case of hallux rigidus. PolycUnic, Lond., 1903,117-9.— Jack, E. A. The aetiology of hallux rigidus. Brit. J. Surg., 1939-40, 27: 492-7.—Kingreen, O. Die Beugecontractur der Grosszehe und ihre Behandlung. Arch. klin. Chir., 1927, 147: 782-8. ------ Zur Aetiologie des Hallux flexus. Zbl. Chir., 1933, 60: 2116-8.—Lindemann, K. Die juvenile Arthritis deformans des Grosszehengrundgelenkes (Hallux ridigus) Zschr. Orthop., 1935-36, 64: 391-403. Also Zbl. Chir., 1936, 63: 1074.—Mau, C. Das Krankheitsbild des Hallux rigidus. Munch, med. Wschr., 1928, 75: 1193-6.—Mills, G. P. The operative treatment of hallux rigidus. Am. J. Surg., 1929, n. Ber., 6: 443.—Monberg, A. On the treatment of hallux rigidus. Acta orthop. scand., 1935, 6: 239-47.—Pap, K. [Hallux rigidus] Orv. hetil., 1939, 83: 861.—Ribbing, S. Besteht ein Zusammenhang zwischen HaUux rigidus und den ossalen aseptischen Nekrosen? Acta orthop. scand., 1935, 6: 138-49.—Richter, H. HaUux flexus. Zschr. orthop. Chir., 1927, 48: 31-5.—Schiiller, J. Ueber Streckhemmung der Grosszehe im Grundgelenk und ihre chirurgische Behandlung. Beitr. klin. Chir., 1928, 142: 471-81.—Strombeck, J. P. Hallux rigidus und seine Behandlung. Acta chir. scand., 1933, 73: 53-83, 8 pi.—Thomsen, W. Ueber die Bedeutung der Plantar- aponeurose fur die Mechanik der Grosszehe (Hallux rigidus und HaUux valgus) Zschr. orthop. Chir., 1934, 61: 488-504 — Timmer, H. HaUux flexus (oder rigidus) Deut. med. Wschr., 1929, 55: 1082-4. ------ [Hallux flexus sive rigidus] Ned. tschr. geneesk., 1928, 72: 2781-9.—Wagner, L. C. The o perative correction of extreme flexion contraction of the great toe. J. Bone Surg., 1934, 16: 914-8.—Watermann, H. Die Arthritis deformans des Grosszehengrundgelenkes als selb- standiges KrankheitsbUd. Zschr. orthop. Chir., 1927, 48: 346- 55. ---- Sesamoid bones. Cypin, E. Contribution a l'etude des frac- tures du se'samoide interne du gros orteil. 36p. 25^cm. Par., 1939. Gasser, P. J. M. *Etude anatomique, physio- logique et pathologique des sesamoides metatarso- phalangiens du gros orteil. 77p. 8? Par., 1926. Ladouch, G. E. V. Contribution a l'etude des fractures des sesamoides du gros orteil. 41p. 25}£cm. Bord., 1933. Inge, G. A. L. Congenital absence of the medial sesamoid bone of the great toe; report of 2 cases. J. Bone Surg., 1935, 18: 188-90. ------ & Ferguson, A. B. Surgery of the sesamoid bones of the great toe; an anatomic and cUnical study, with a report of 41 cases. Arch. Surg., 1933, 27: 466-89.—Lapidus, P. W. Congenital unUateral absence of the medial sesamoid of the great toe; report of a case. J. Bone Surg., 1939, 21: 208. ------ A definite fracture of tibial sesamoid of the big toe. Radiology, 1941, 36: 235-7.—Leoni & Maruani. Fracture du sesamoide interne du gros orteil. J. radiol. electa., 1936, 20: 623.—Meis, F. Ueber Osteochondropathie der Sesambeine des Grosszehengrundgelenks und ihre Beziehungen zur statischen Insuffizienz des Vorfusses. Arch, orthop. UnfaUchir., 1928, 26: 581-92.—Mouchet, A. Fracture du sesamoide interne du gros orteil gauche (de cause indirecte) Bull. Soc. chir. Paris, 1920, 46: 523.—Owre. A. [Osteomalacia in sesamoid bone of great toe; case] Med. rev., Bergen, 1929, 46: 314-6.—Powers, J. H. Sesamoid bones of the great toe. Am. J. Surg., 1934, 23: 315- 21. Also repr.—Royer, M. Fracture du s6samoide interne du gros orteil. J. radiol. electa., 1937, 21: 159.—Treves, A. Un cas de sesamoidite interne du gros orteil. Rev. orthop., Par., 1928, 3. ser., 15: 411-3. ---- Surgery. Bar, H. Die technische Vervollkommnung der Hallux- und Zehenoperationen mittels Osteotomiezangen. Zbl. Chir., 1928, 55: 2765-7.—Jones, R. Transplantation of extensor proprius hallucis to head of first metatarsal. In Stereo Clinic (Howard A. KeUy) [Troy, N. Y., 1913] Sect. 7.—Kron, E. Uebungssandale zur Nachbehandlung bei Grosszehenopera- tionen. Arch, orthop. UnfaUchir., 1938-39, 39: 739-41.— Lambotte, A. Quelques considerations sur l'arthroplastie du gros orteil. Paris chir., 1928, 20: 33-6. ---- valgus. Hoppchen, J. *Zur Aetiologie des Hallux valgus. 25p. 8? Bresl., 1919. Nakhdjavani Abbas. *Hallux valgus familial [Paris] 54p. 8? Troyes, 1936. .Naumann, W. *Statistik der Erkrankungen des Grosszehengrundgelenks und der Stellungs- anomalien der grossen Zehe in den Jahren 1926 und 1927 [Berlin] 35p. 8? Brandenburg, 1929. Pernice, H. [E. A.] *Ueber die Pathogenese des Hallux valgus [Freiburg] 31p. 8? Stockach, 1928. Allan, F. G. Hallux valgus and rigidus. Brit. M. J., 1940, 1: 579-81.—Alpsoy, C. [Observations on hallux valgus] Askeri sihhiye mecmuasi, 1939, 68: No. 28, 28-32— BSIacescu. Un caz de hallux valgus simetric Rev. cbir., Bucur., 1903, 7: 128-35.—Easier, A. Der Hallux valgus und seine Vermeidung. Miinch. med. Wschr., 1937, 84: 1333-5.—Bedrich, F. [Etio- logical factors of development of hallux valgus] Bratisl. lek. listy, 1924, 3: 310-29, 4 pi.—Berntsen, A. [Hallux valgus] Ugeskr. lasger, 1929, 91: 397-400. ------ De l'hallux valgus; contribution k son 6tiologie et k son traitement. Rev. orthop., Par., 1930, 3. ser., 17: 101-11.—Blencke, B. Der Hallux valgus- Komplex. Zschr. arztl. Fortbild., 1939, 36: 518.—Bogomolova, A. G. [Hallux valgus] Ortop. travmat., 1938,12: No. 3, 30-4— Boks, D. B. [Concerning the valgus-position and the claw- position of the great toe] Med. wbl. Nederland, 1921-22, 28: 429-32.—Bradford, E. H. Hallux valgus. Am. J. Orthop. Surg., 1914-15, 12: 170-2.—Buka, A. J. Bunion and hallux valgus. Am. J. Surg., 1930, n. ser., 8: 332-6.—Clybourne, H. E. Tailor's bunion. J. Am. Osteopath. Ass., 1935-36, 35: 205. Also Health Shoe Digest, 1937, 2: No. 4, 29-31. ------ Bunion; hallux valgus; tailor's bunion. J. Am. Osteopath. Ass., 1939-40, 39: 461-4.—Cordingley, E. W. Bunions. J. Nat. Ass. Chiropod., 1928, 18: 11-8. Also Clin. J. Chiropody, 1933,6:41-51. ------ Hallux valgus complicated by extreme erosions and dislocations; interesting case report submitted. Ibid 1938-39, 10: 92.—Daw, S. W. An unusual type of hallux valgus (2 cases) Brit. M. J., 1935, 2: 580, pi.—Dawbarn, R. H. M. Double haUux valgus. Ann. Surg., 1914, 60: 513.— Dreesmann. Hallux valgus und Metatarsus varus. Med. KUn., Berl., 1928, 24: 1740-3.—Ely, L. W. Hallux valgus. Surg. Clin. N. America, 1926, 6: 425-31.—Ewald, C. Wie entsteht der Hallux valgus? Wien. med. Wschr., 1938, 88: 973.—Feher, F. Ueber Hallux valgus. Verh. Verein. Orthop. Wiens (1937) 1938, 88-93.—Glissan, D. J. HaUux valgus and HALLUX 44 HALLUX minimi;- varus. Austral. N. Zealand J. Surg., 1935-36, 5: 389- 96.- II uteri-Torn, O. Hallux valgus, eine transformatorischc Folge ,i 1 Ausdruck der Schiidigung der Fussgewolbe. Arch. klin. ( l.i!., 1925, 135: 190-2. llald. J. K. [HaUux valgus and other tut troubles] Norsk mag. lsegevid., 1931, 92: 933-52, 10 pi.—Hallux valgus. Rev. med. mil., Mex., 1938, 1: No. 4, 11-24.—Hiss. J. M. The role played by malalignment of entire foot in bunion formation. Health Shoe Digest. 1936, 10: 40; 44.— Hoffmann, H. Die Phalanx Hallueis valga congenita. Zschr. Orthop., 1936, 65: 353-60.—Hohmann, G. Der Hallux valgus und die ubrigen Zehenverkrummungen. Erg. Chir. Orthop., 1C25, 18: 308-76.—Horvath, B. [Hallux valgus] Orv. hetil., 1926, 70: 709-11.— Hughes, W. K. HaUux valgus. J. CoU. Surgeons Australasia. 1928, 1: 214-0. — Kaimus, R. Beitrag zur Frage nach der Entstehungsursache des Hallux valgus. Arch, orthop. UnfaUchir., 1931. 30: 84-96.—Klar, M. M. Ueber angeborenen HaUux valgus. Zschr. orthop. Chir., 1905, 14: 304-11.—Kohl, H. Zusatzliches zur Frage des Hallux valgus und seine Vermeidung. Miinch. med. Wschr., 1937, 84: 1666.—Komza, J. [On hallux valgus] Chir. narz. ruchu, 1936, 9: 115-40, pi.—Lloyd, E. I. Prognosis of hallux valcriis and hallux rigidus. Lancet, Lond., 1935. 2: 263.— Lycklama h Nijeholt, H. J. Hallux valgus. Ned. tschr. gi nees-k., 1920, 1: 1711.—Mensor, M. C. HaUux valgus; report of cases. California West. M., 1928, 28: 314-5.—Moatz. J. D. HaUux valgus and hallux rigidus. Clin. J. Chiropody. 1937-38. 9: 85-7.—Monberg, Q. [On haUux valgus deformities] Hospi- talstidende, 1921, 64: 521-7.—Morris, A. R. Etiology of hallux valgus. J. Nat. Ass. Chiropod., 1940, 30: No. 8, 12-6.— Miihsam, R. Zur Frage des Hallux valgus. Mschr. Geburtsh. Gyn., 1926, 75: 65-8.—Painter, C. F. Hallux valgus. J. Bone Surg., 1937, 19: 370-2.—Payr, E. Hallux valgus und Konstitu- tionspathologie. Zbl. Chir., 1925, 52: 2289-91.—Pick, H. Zur Frage der Infektiositat der Schleimbeutel beim Hallux valgus. Ibid., 1927, 54: 70-2.—Rayo. F. Hallux valgus doble [case] Bol. Soc. cir. Chile, 1926, 4: 16.5-9.—Robinson. H. A. Ktiologv of hallux valgus. J. Am. Osteop. Ass., 1924-25, 24: 588. Also Mil. Surgeon, 1928, 62: 807-13.—Silfvcrskiold, N. Metatarsus latus und Hallux valgus. Acta chir. scand., 1920-27, 61 : 543- 60.—Sirrt. S. [Hallux valgus] Asked silihive mecmuasi, 1932, 61: 22-30.—Stanley, L. I... & lireck, L. W. Bunions. J. Bone Surg., 1935, 17: 961-4. Strncker, O. Hallux valgus. Wien. klin. Wschr., 1929, 42: 624; 1940, 53: 885.— TimmiT, H. [The causes of hallux valgus] Ned. tschr. geneesk., 1920, 70: pt 2, 998. ------ [Role of sesamoid bones in hallux valgusl Ibid., 1928, 72: pt 2, 5869-73. Also Deut. med. Wschr.. 1928. 54:1927. ------ [Origin of hallux valgus, malformation of the toes in spread foot, pes valgus and pes plano-valgus, caused by shoes, and discription of an apparatus for the demonstration and explanation of the origin of hallux valgusl Ned. tschr. geneesk., 1940, 84: 1555-66.—Tremblay, J. Hallux valgus et orteil en marteau. Union med. Canada, 1937, 66: 070. ■■ Truslow, W. Metatarsus primus varus or hallux valgus? J. Hone Surg., 1925, 7: 98-108.—Valerio, A. A propositi! do hallux valgus. Brasil med., 1930, 44: 829.— Weil, M. P., 2cm. Lond., H. K. Lewis & co., 1920. Also 10. ed. xxxii, 284p. 1928. Also 11. ed. xxxi, 366p. 1931. Also 12. ed. xxi, 355p. 1938. HAM, C[onstance] I[rene] See Short, A. R., & Ham, C. I. A synopsis of physiology. 2. ed. 312p. 8? Brist., 1936. HAM. See Meat; Pork. HAMACHER, Luci, 1905- *Psychische und nervose Schadigungen durch die Narkose. 35p. 8? Bonn, P. Kubens, 1932. HAMACHER, Wilhelm Heinz, 1895- *Der Verlauf des Lungenabscesses in Beziehung zu seiner Lokalisation. 63p. tab. 8? Bonn, A. Brand, 1934. HAMACREADIUM. See also Trematoda. McCoy, O. R. The life-history of a marine trematode, Hamacreadium mutabile Linton, 1910. Parasitology, Lond., 1929, 21: 220-5. HAMADE, Amin Farhan. *Les polynevrites; post-typhiques. 29p. 8? Geneve, E. Meyer, 1928. HAMAMELIDACEAE [and derivatives] Berry, H. Extract of Hamamelis. Pharm. J., Lond., 1936, 4. ser., 83: 247.—Hilton, S. L. Aqua hamamelidis N. F. Hamamelis water, witch hazel water, distilled extract of witch hazel. J. Am. Pharm. Ass., 1930, 19: 232-5 —Lloyd, J. U., & Lloyd J. T. History of Hamamelis (witch hazel) extract and distillate. Ibid., 1935, 24: 220-4— Mercier, F., & Balsanard, J. Sur les constituants de l'Hamamehs virgimca. C. rend. Soc. biol 1936 121:671.—Mercier, F., & Vignoll, L. Remarques sur des essais physiologiques de l'extrait fluide d'hamamelis. Ibid., 668-71. HAMANN, Carl August, 1868-1929. C, G. W. [Obituary] Tr. Am. Surg. Ass., 1929, 47: 416 — Crile G. W. Obituary. P. verb. Congr. Soc. internat. chir., 1932 9. Congr., 1: 115.—Dickenson, J. (Remarks by Dr Dickenson on°the occasion of the presentation of a Portrait in bronze of Dr Hamann to the museum of the Cleveland Medical Library Association, April 15th) Bull. Acad M. Cleveland, 1932, 16: 10—Obituary. J. Am. M. Ass., 1930, 94: 203. HAMANN, Erich, 1881- *Ueber den Einfluss der Behandlung der Mutter auf das Auftreten der kongenitalen Syphilis. 52p. 8? Wurzb., C. J. Becker, 1927. HAMANN, Erich, 1912- *Tromsulin in der Rinderpraxis unter besonderer Beriicksichti- gung der Abortus-Bang-Infektion. 55p. 8? [Lpz., n. pub.] 1938. HAMANN, Fritz, 1905- *Zur Aetiologie und Behandlung der Pseudarthrosen. 24p. 8°. Berl. [n. pub.] 1933. HAMANN, Gerhard, 1911- *Zur Klinik der Psoriasis pustulosa [Berlin] 34p. 8? Grossenhain, H. Plasnick, 1936. HAMANN, Horst, 1912- *Induratio penis plastica, Dupuytrensche Fingerkontraktur und Keloid in ihren Beziehungen zueinander und die Frage der Erbbedingtheit dieser Krankheits- zustande. 33p. 8? Bresl., R. Nischkowsky, 1938. HAMANN, Karl Heinz, 1913- *Experi- mentelle physikalische und chemische Unter- suchungen mit der neuen Priifmaschine des Jota-Werks zur Feststellung der Abnutzung zahnarztlicher Zemente. 27p. 22cm. Koln, J. Borowsky, 1936. HAMANN, Martin, 1898- *Organische Erkrankungen und Prognose bei begutachteten Fallen von Asthma bronchiale. 36p. 8? Berl. [n. pub.] 1933. HAMANN, Rudi, 1913- *Experimentelle Untersuchungen iiber das biologische und sero- logische Verhalten vergrunender Streptokokken und Enterokokken. 17p. 20Micm. Konigsb.- Pr., Gebr. Wetzki, 1937. HAMANNIA. See Echinuria. HAMARTOMA. See Tumor. HAMATUM [carpi] See under Carpus. HAMBERGER, Dieter, 1914- *Ueber den Mineralstoffwechsel des Menschen: Die Wirkung von Salzsaure, Ammoniumchlorid und Ammoniak auf den Saure-Basen-Haushalt. 19p. 4 tab. 8? Jena, Buro Hellas, 1937. HAMBERGER, Hugo. *Ueber das Myom der Portio vaginalis. 29p. 8? Miinch., A. Kapfhammer, 1927. HAMBLEN, Edwin Crowell, 1900- Endo- crine gynecology, xxviii, 453p. illust. 5 pi. diagr. 26cm. Springf., 111., C. C Thomas [1939] HAMBLEY, Wilfred D., & BEDFORD, T. Preliminary notes on atmospheric conditions in boot and shoe factories (Boot and shoe series No. 2) 69p. 2 ch. 8 diagr. 8? Lond., H. M. Stat. Off., 1921. Forms Rep. No. 11, Gr. Britain Privy Counc Med. Res. Counc, Indust. Fatigue Res. Bd. HAMBLY, Wilfrid D. The history of tatooing and its significance, with some account of other forms of corporal marking. 346p. 7 pi. map. 8° Lond., H. F. & G. Witherby, 1925. HAMBOURG, Charles, 1902- *Sur la presence des traces de plomb dans les visceres humains; contribution a l'etude du saturnisme. 42p. 8? Par., Jouve & cie, 1928. HAMBRECHT, Philipp, 1904- *Oeso- phagusdivertikel [Heidelberg] 33p. 8? Hora- burg-Saar K. Knaben-Erziehungsheim [1931] HAMBRESIN, L. Les medications de choc en ophthalmologie. 1 p. 1. 251p. 25>km. Par., Masson & cie, 1938. 227475—vor.. 7, 4th series- HAMBROOK 50 HAMBURG HAMBROOK, London. Village Hospital [Kstabslihed 1867] Annual reports 1.-18., 1S67-S4. HAMBUECHEN, Eva Dorothee [geb. Pietr- kowski] 1900- *Ueber die Reaktion tieri- scher Gewebe und deren Beeinflussung durch die Ernahrung; ein Beitrag zur Vitalfarbung mit Indikatoren. 13p. 8? [Berl., n. pub.] 1930. HAMBURG, Germ. Allgemeines Kranken- haus St Georg. Aerztliche Berichte iiber die Irrenanstalt. 1858-1861; 1865-74. —— Annalen der chirurgischen Abtheilung. Bd 1-2, 1828-33. ---- Berichte iiber die Administration des ... 1.-2., 1824-25. ----Bericht der Verw altung fiir die Jahre 1S01-72. fol. 1862-73. ----Jahresbericht der Vervvaltungsbehorden. 1877-78. —— Festschrift zum lOOjahrigen Bestehen. x, 184p. roy. 8? Lpz., L. Voes, 1925. See also Hegler. Das Allgemeine Krankenhaus St Georg in Hamburg. In Hyg. u. soz. Hyg. in Hamburg, 1928, 118-35. HAMBURG, Germ. Barmbeck Krankenhaus. Allgemeine Krankenhaus (Das) 73p. 2 pl. 8? Hamb. [n. pub.] 1924. HAMBURG, Germ. Heilstatte Edmundsthal- Siemerswalde. Festschrift zum 25jahrigen Be- stehen. viii, 150p. 2 portr. 8? Hamb., 1924. HAMBURG, Germ. Ibero-Amerikanisches Institut. Ibero-Amerikanische Studien. Hamb., No. 9, 1937 HAMBURG, Germ. Institut fur Schiffs- und Tropenkrankheiten in Hamburg. Festschrift Bernhard Nocht zum 80. Geburtstag (4. Nov. 1937) von seinen Freunden und Schlilern. x, 704p. 29 pl. portr. fold map. tab. diagr. 28cm. Hamb., F. de Gruyter & co., 1937. HAMBURG, Germ. Irren-Anstalt Friedrichs- berg. Aerztliche Berichte. 1861, 1865-74. fol. Hamb., 1862-75. HAMBURG. Statistisches Landesamt. Aus Hamburgs Verwaltung und Wirtschaft; Alonats- schrift des Statistischen Landesamts. Hamb., v.l, 1924- ---- Statistisches Jahrbuch fiir die freie und Hansestadt Hamburg. Hamb. (1925-) 1926- HAMBURG, Germ. Hygiene und soziale Hygiene in Hamburg; zur neunzigsten Versammlung der Dcutschen Naturforscher und Aerzte in Hamburg im Jahre 1928. 672p. 4° Hamb., 1928. Langeluddeke, A. Das medizinische Gross- Hamburg; ein Fiihrer fiir Aerzte. 140p. 8? Hamb., 1933. Altersaufbau (Der) der Wohnbevolkerung in der Stadt Hamburg. Hamburgs Verwalt., 1934, 11: 93-8.—Besuch (Der) der Hamburgischen Universitat im Sommer 1934. Ibid., 195-8.—Bevolkerungsentwicklung und Wohnungsbau in Gross-Hamburg seit 1933. Ibid., 1937, 14: 60-6.—Ehe- schliessungen, Geburten und Sterbefalle in Gross-Hamburg im Jahre 1937. Ibid., 1938, 15: 25-9.—Girones, L. Lo qug es el Hospital Barmbeck de Hamburgo. Rev. m£d,, Barcelona, 1927, 2. ser., 7: 420-8 Krankenanstalten (Die) im ham- burgischen Staat im Jahre 1935 nach den Erhebungen der Reichs.statistik. Hamburgs Verwalt, 1936, 13: 169-71 — Kummell, H., & Weygandt, W. Die Einrichtungen der Medizinischen Fakultiit in Hamburg. Klin. Wschr., 1928, 7: 1773-7.—Linne. Oeffentliche Aula^en und Spielpl'atze. ' In Hyg. u. soz. Hyg. in Hamb. 1928, 648-54.—Nowicki, E. [Institute of tropical medicine in Hamburg] Przegl wet 1939, 51: 36; 180— Peters. Di<- Foi tfiilu ung der Sanierung der AltMadt in Hamburg. Techn. Gemeindebl., 1925-26, 28: 269-72— Ranck. Neue (U .sundungsmassnahmen in ' der Hamburger Innenstadt. Ibid., 1935, 38: 181-4.—Reiche, F Die Bedeutung Hamburgs in der Entwicklung der medizini- schen W issenschaf t. Klin. Wschr., 1928, 7: 1769-73 — Vagedes, K. von. Von einer Studienreise'nach Hamburg hleme Mitt. \ erein \\ asserversorg., 1932, 8: 217-38 — Wohnungsordnung fiir die vorwiegend stiidtiM-hen Teile der Hansestadt Hamburg. Reichsgesundhbl., 193X, 13: 102-4. HAMBURGER, Christian. Studies on gona- dotropic hormones from the hypophysis and chorionic tissue, with special reference to their differences. 184p. 8? Kbh., Levin & Munks- gaard, 1933. Forms Suppl. 17, Acta path, microb. scand. ---- Atemorgane. iv, p.491-700. illust. 8? Berl., J. Springer, 1934. Forms 6. Lfg, Vorlesung. u. vergl. Anat. fO. Butschli] HAMBURGER, Franz, 1874- Kinder- heilkunde; kurzgefasstes Lehrbuch fiir prakti- sche Aerzte und Studenten. 2. Aufl. vii, 277p. 8? Lpz., F. Deuticke, 1932. ---- Die Diphtherie; kurzgefasstes Hand- buch. vi, 1, 280p. illust. pl. 8? Berl., Urban & Schwarzenberg, 1937. HAMBURGER, Jean, 1909- *Physi- ologie de l'innervation renale. 181p. 8? Par., Presses Modernes, 1936. See also Vallery-Radot, P., Hamburger, J., & Blamoutier, P. Les migraines. 231 p. 8? Par., 1935. HAMBURGER, Maurice, 1895- *L'iso- agglutination; groupes sanguins du nouveau-nd et du nourrisson. 148p. 8? Par., L. Arnette, 1927. ---- Le traitement de la dysenterie ami- bienne. 2, 83, lp. 8? Par., J. B. Bailliere, 1935. HAMBURGER, Maxim, 1899- *Er- fahrungen iiber Knochelbruche bei Versicherten und Nichtversicherten [Berlin] p.283-96. 8? Charlottenb., Gebr. Hoffmann, 1934. Also Arch, orthop. UnfaUchir., 1932-33, 32: HAMBURGER, Rudolf Jacobus. *Over den invloed van insuline op de permeabiliteit der weefsels voor glucose. 55p. 8? Groningen, M. de Waal, 1930. HAMBURGER statistische Monatsberichte. Hamb., 1924-26. Continued as Hamburgs Verwaltung und Wirtschaft. HAMBURGER Wochenschrift fiir Aerzte und Zahnarzte. Hamb., Jg. 4, Nos. 1-6, 1913. HAMBURGS (Aus) Verwaltung und Wirt- schaft. Hamb., v.4, 1927- Formerly Hamburger statistische Monatsberichte. HAMBY, Wallace Bernard, 1903- The hospital care of neurosurgical patients, xi, 118p. illust. diagr. 21 ^cm. Springf., 111., C. C Thomas [1940] For biography see Phi Chi Q., Menasha, 1935, 32: 357, portr. HAMDI, Hassan, 1873-1936. Aygun, K. S. [Obituary] Verh. Deut. path. Ges., 1937, 29: 367-9. HAMEAU, Jean, 1779-1851. Chabe, A. [Biography] Biogr. med., Par., 1934, 8: 17-32, 4 pl.—Jean Hameau, precurseur de Pasteur, decouvre la pellagre. J. med. Bordeaux, 1929, 59: 790-6. HAMEDY, Abdullah, 1902- *De l'apti- tude des animaux a la production des antitoxines diphterique et tetanique [Alfort] 152p. 8° Par., Vigot freres, 1931. HAMEL [Carl] 1870- r, Siee ,^ntwic!?,oUn?. (Die) des deutschen Gesundheitswesens [&c] 155p. 4? Berl., 1931. HAMEL, Jean, 1901- *A propos d'une forme speaale d'angio-lymphangiome congenital gene>ahs6 de la peau paraissant du a un 6tat dystrophique et dysembryoplasique du tegu- ment. 62p. pl. 8? Par., Jouve & cie, 1928. See also Drouet P L., & Hamel, J. L'heredo-syphilis mentale. 20op. 8? Par., 1930. For biography see Hyg. ment., Par., 1936, 31: portr. HAMEL, Jean Roger, 1904- *Considera- tions chniques et therapeutiques sur 25 observa- HAMEL 51 HAMILTON tions nouvelles de pentonites aigues d'origine salpingienne. 65p. 8? Par., Libr. E. Le Francois, 1937. HAMEL, Paul, 1913- Contribution a l'etude de la goutte aigue; £tude clinique des formes atypiques. 59p. 24cm. Par., M. Vigne, 1939. HAMELIN, Jean, 1899- *De quelques notions critiques sur la pathogenie et le traite- ment de l'angijie de poitrine. lOlp. 8? Par., Vigot freres, 1934. HAMELIN, Robert, 1908- ^Contribution a l'etude de la parturition dans les uterus mal- formes. 62p. 8? Par., Jouve & cie, 1935. HAMELIN-GAPIN, Robert, 1904- *La diathermo-coagulation et l'6tincelage de haute frequence dans le traitement du lupus nasal tuberculeux et de ses complications cutanees. 73p. 8? Par., E. Le Francois, 1934. HAMELMANN, Paul, 1907- *Ueber die tuberkulosen Lymphome des Halses. 35p. 8? Kiel [n. pub.] 1933. HAMER, Philip May, 1891- The cen- tennial history of the Tennessee State Medical Association, 1830-1930. 580p. 14 pl. 8°. Nashville, Tenn., Tennessee State M. Ass., 1930. HAMER, Sir William [Heaton] 1862-1936. Epidemiology old and new. x, 180p. ch. 8? Lond., K. Paul, Trench, Trubner & co., 1928. For biography see Brit. M. J., 1936, 2: 154 (Greenwood) Also Lancet, Lond., 1936, 2: 161. Also Nature, Lond., 1936, 138: 192. HAMERNIK, Josef. Smilauerova, B. [Biography] Prof. Dr Josef Hamernfk. 17p. 8? Praha, 1926. HAMILL, Philip. Editor of Murrell, William. Murrell's What to do in cases of poisoning. 14. ed. 208p. 16? Lond., 1934. HAMILL, Samuel McCIintock, 1864- Hamill (Dr) receives Strittmatter award. J. Am. M. Ass., 1939, 112: 1841. HAMILL, William H., 1908- *The acid- base catalysis of the mutarotation of glucose in protium oxide-deuterium oxide mixtures [Co- lumbia Univ.] [7p.] 4? N. Y. [n. pub.] 1936. Also J. Phys. Chem., 1936, 4: 395-401. HAMILTON, Alexander, 1739-1802. Out- lines of the theory and practice of midwifery; to which are added Smellie's anatomical tables with explanations. 2. ed. xiv, 400p. pl. 8°. Phila., T. Dobson, 1806. HAMILTON, Alice, 1869- Industrial toxicology, xix, p. 1. 329p. 12? N. Y., Harper [1934] For biography see Indust. M., 1935, 4: 421-7, portr. For portrait, photograph see collection in library. HAMILTON, Anna, 1864-1935. Winckler, M. [Obituary] Internat. Nurs. Rev., Geneve, 1936, 10: 2-9, portr. HAMILTON, Arthur Stephen, 1872-1940. McKinley, J. C. Obituary. Arch. Neur. Psychiat., Chic, 1940, 44: 1323, portr. Also Tr. Am. Neur. Ass., 1940, 66: 224. Also J. Am. M. Ass., 1940, 115: 398. Also J. Nerv. Ment. Dis., 1940, 92: 418. Also Minnesota M., 1941, 24: 136. HAMILTON, Beryl E. See Zahorsky, John, & Hamilton, Beryl E. Pediatric nursing. 568p. 8? S. Louis, 1936. HAMILTON, Burton Everett, 1885- , & THOMSON, Karl Jefferson. The heart in pregnancy and the childbearing age; with a sec- tion entitled Delivery and obstetrical after-care of cardiacs, by Frederick C. Irving, viii, 402p. pl. diagr. 24cm. Bost., Little, Brown & co., 1941. HAMILTON, C[harles] Kfeith] J[ohnstone] See Russell, H. B., & Hamilton, C. K. J. Heart disease in childhood. 104p. 8? Lond., 1929. Also Tallerman, K. H., & Hamilton, C. K. J. The principles of infant nutrition and their practical application. 183p. 8? Lond., 1928. HAMILTON, Cosmo. Who cares? a story of adolescence. 319p. 8? Lond., Hurst & Blackett, 192?] HAMILTON, E. Louise, 1904- *The effect of delayed incentive on the hunger drive in the white rat [Columbia Univ.] p. 137-207. 8? Worcester, Mass. [n. pub.] 1929. HAMILTON, Frank Hastings, 1813-86. [Notes on inflammation, ulcers, wounds, venerea, case books, regions, fractures, dislocations, joints, amputations, eye, ear, neuroses, reparative surgery, obstetrics] Ms. 18v. 4? [n. p., n. pub.] ca. 1845-71. ---- Practical treatise on fractures and dis- locations. 4. ed. xxiv, 789p. 8? Phila., H. C. Lea, 1871. ---- The principles and practice of surgery. 2. ed. xxvi, 954p. illust. 8? N. Y., W. Wood & Co., 1874. ---- Essentials of physiology and hygiene; a text-book to accompany White's physiological manikin. 46p. 8? N. Y., J. T. White & co., 1886* 1889 HAMILTON, Gordon, & KRUCKENBERG, Edith. A medical social terminology. 2 p. 1. vii-x, 36p. 8? N. Y., Social Serv. Dep. Presby- terian Hosp. [1930] HAMILTON, Hughbert C, 1903- *The effect of incentives on accuracy of discrimination measured on the Galton bar [Columbia Univ.] 70p. 8? N. Y., [n. pub.] 1939. Also Arch. Psychol., 1929, No. 103. HAMILTON, J. Bruce. A guide to ophthalmic operations, xv, 201p. 22cm. Lond., H. K. Lewis & co., 1940. HAMILTON, James M[adison] 1868- Editor of Yearbook of the New York and New England Association of Railway Surgeons. Rutland, Vt., v.34-43, 1924 - 33. HAMILTON, T. Glendenning, 1883-1935. Obituary. Canad. M. Ass. J., 1935, 32: 710. HAMILTON, Thomas Dalling, 1880-1936. [Obituary] J. Path. Bact., Lond., 1936, 43: 431. HAMILTON, T[om] S[herman] 1894- See Mitchell, Harold Hanson & Hamilton, T. S. The biochemistry of the amino acids. 619p. 8? N. Y., 1929. HAMILTON, Virginia Clay, 1902- See Sweden. Befolkningskommissionen. Report on the sex question. 182p. 21cm. Bait., 1940. HAMILTON, W. G. Compend of domestic medicine and household remedies with the treat- ment of diseases of adult and infant [&c] 250p. 12? Greensboro, N. C, Phillips & Stout bros, 1887. HAMILTON, Walter Irving, 1877- , & KIDNER, T. B. Advising the tuberculous about employment, ix, 171p. 12? Bait., Williams & Wilkins co., 1926. HAMILTON, William James, 1903- See Appleton, Arthur Beeny, Hamilton, W. J., & Tchaperoff, I. C. C. Surface and radiological anatomy. 311p. 24} 2cm. Cambr. [Engl., 1938] HAMILTON, William Patrick, 1911- *Oral cholecystography [Wisconsin Univ.] 22p. 8? S. Paul, Minnesota [n. pub.] 1936. Typewritten. HAMILTON, Ontario, Canada. Mountain Sanatorium [Tuberculosis] Annual report. Hamilton, 1907-8; 1911-1917-18; 1925-26; 23., 1927. HA Minh Phong, 1910- ^Contribution a l'6tude de la pollution des cours d'eau et du sous- sol par les produits d'industrie. 87p. 24cm. Par., Press. Modern., 1939. II AMITE 9 HAMMARSTEN HAMITE. Sec also Berber; Egypt; Ethiopia, &c. Dribcri; J. H. A note on the classification of Half-Hamites in i: -. \iica. Man, Lond., 1939, 39: 20.—Huntingford, G. W. 15. < >i ihe cln — ification of the Half-Hamites of East Africa. Ibid., 187-90.- I.ukas, J. Die Verbreitung der Hamiten in Afrika. Scientia. Bologna, 1939, 65: 108-18. HAMLET. Shakespeare, W. The tragedy of Hamlet, prince of Denmark. Amer. ed. by W. M. Hart 262p. 16? N. Y. [1917] Yearsley, P. M. The sanity of Hamlet. lOlp. 12? Lond., 1932. Hinrichsen, O. Der vcrstandliche-unverstandene Hamlet. Schweiz. Arch. Neur. Psychiat., 1933, 31: 261; 32: 33. HAMLEY, Edward Bruce, 1824-93. The operations of war explained and illustrated. xxii p. 491p. maps. 8? Edinb., W. Black- wood & Sons, 1878. HAMLIN, Harris Howard, 1896-1940. Watts, ('. E. Obituary. Ann. Int. M., 1940-41, 14: 352. HAMLIN, Joseph Reagan, 1885-1936. Obituary. J. Missouri M. Ass., 1937, 34: 248. HAMM, Hans, 1908- *Hilft das Calcium bei postoperativer Tetanie? [Wurzburg] 20p. 8? Hamb., H. Kampen, 1932. HAMM, Homer A., 1903- *The reten- tivity of water by purified cotton cellulose [Johns Hopkins Univ.] p.401-9. 8? Bait. [n. pub.] 1936. HAMM, Germ. Walter, J. *Untersuchungen iiber die Krank- heitsverhaltnis.se der erwerbstatigen Jugendlichen in der Stadt Hamm (Westf.) [Munster] 22p. 8? Quakenbriick, 1933. HAM MA, Karl, 1912- *Uebor den Ein- fluss des Keimdrusenhormons auf die Libido [Heidelberg] 16p. 21cm. Zeulenroda, B. Sporn, 1937. HAM MANN, Eberhard, 1901- *Ge- faszschadigungen bei Sepsis lenta. 32p. 8? Breslau [n. pub.] 1925. HAMMANN, Gustav, 1908- *Zur Frage der prognostischen Bedeutung der negativen T- Zacke im PJlektrokardiogramm (mit statistischen Zusammenstellungen) 32p. 8? Giessen, O. Kindt, 1934. HAMMANN, Hermann de Vfilliers] 1913- *Eigenblut als unspezifische Reiztherapie [Miin- chen] 43p. 22cm. Diisseld., G. H. Nolte, 1938. HAMMANN. Wilhelm, 1902- *Ueber das \rorkommen virulenter Tetanusbazillen im Magendarmkanal auf Grund von Beobachtungen nach Magenoperationen. 19p. 8? Wiirzb., C. J. Becker, 1926. HAMMAR, J. August, 1861- An English translation of Sandstroem's Glandulae parathy- reoideae, with biographical notes by J. August Hammar. p. 179-222. portr. 8? Bait., 1938. In Bull. Inst. Hist. M., Bait., 1938, 6: HAMMARSTEN, Greta. *Eine experimen- telle Studie iiber* Calciumoxalat als Steinbildner in den Harnwegen; speziell mit Rucksicht auf die Bedeutung des Magnesiums, loop. 26cm. Lund, C. W. K. Gleerup & O. Harrassowitz [1937] HAMMARSTEN, Olof, 1841-1932. Text- book of physiological chemistry; authorized translation from the author's enlarged and re- vised third German edition bv John A. Mandel 2. ed. x, 705p. 8? X. Y.,* J. Wiley & Sons! 189S. For biography see Erg. Physiol., 1933, 35: 13-31 (I. Ihun- berg) Also Kin. lak. sail, hand., 1933, 75: 25-7, portr. (R. Ehrstrom) Also Hygiea, Stockh., 1932, 94: 737-12, portr. (O. Blix) Also Upsala liik. foren. forh., 1933, 38: 19 (C. T. Mbrner) For portrait, photograph see collection in library. HAMMEL, Andre Henri Louis, 1894 Contribution a l'etude physiologique et clinique du D-camphre sulfonate de diethylenediamine. 61p. pl. ch. 8? Par., Je Scrs, 1930. HAMMEL, Erna, 1900- * Ueber einen ungewohnlichen Fall von Melanosarcom der Chorioidea [Heidelberg] 21p. 8? [Ludwigs- hafen, G. Wentz] 1926. HAMMEL, Heiner, 1900- *Ueber Ureter- steine [Heidelberg] 62p. 8? Heppenheim, G. Otto, 1926. HAMMELMANN, Armin, 1909- *Ueber einen seltenen Fall von Calcaneustuberkulose [Munster] 31p. pl. 21cm. Giitersloh, Thiele, 1933. HAMMER, Didier, 1904- Contribution a l'etude des kystes de l'ovaire pendant la grossesse; les observations de la clinique Tarnier de 1919 a 1929. 66p. 8? Par., Press. Modern., 1930. HAMMER, Ernst, 1906-34. Loeschcke. Xi'krolog. Verh. Deut. path. Ges., 1934, 27: 354. HAMMER, Heinrich. Ueber follikulare Zahn- zysten. 32p. 8? Berl., H. Meusser, 1920. Forms Heft 10, Abh. klin. Zahnh. HAMMER, Jakob Barthel Adalbert, 1905- *Beitrag zum Pylorospasmus der Sauglinge. 24p. 8? [Berl., n. pub.] 1931. HAMMER, Joseph, 1909- *Spatunter- suchungen nach Osteochondritis dissecans mit besonderer Rucksicht auf Anzeichen fiir das Auftreten von Gelenkchondromatose [Wurzburg] 16p. 8? Speyer, Pilger, 1936. HAMMER, Ludwig. *Ueber die Frucht- barkeit nach einseitiger Adnexabtragung (zu- gleich ein Beitrag zur Geschlechtsbestimmung) [Basel] 33p. 8? S. Louis [n. pub.] 1928. HAMMER [Maximilian Heinrich] Ernst, 1906- *Ueber akute peptische Gastritis; ein Beitrag zur Lehre vom peptischen Geschwur [Freiburg i. B.] p.485-96. 8? [Naumburg a. S., Lippert & Co.] 1929. Also Beitr. path. Anat., 1929, 82: HAMMER [Richard Ephraim] Johannes, 1900- *Ein Fall von Riesenzellensarkom an der Grundphalanx des Daumens, behandelt durch Exstirpation der Phalanx und freie, autoplas- tische Transplantation einer Zehenphalanx. 34p. 8? Lpz., E. Lehmann, 1925. HAMMERBECK, Woldemar, 1899- *Multiple fibrose Geschwulstknoten (Neuro- fibrome?) der serosen Haute neben doppelseitigen Akustikustumoren und zahlreichen Psammo- endotheliomen der Dura [Leipzig] 31p 8? Riga, R. Ruetz & Co., 1931. HAMMERMANN, Hans, 1904- *Er- fahrungen uber Narkosen mit Evipan-Natrium. 16p. 8? Giessen, W. Herr, 1933. HAMMERSCHLAG, Albert, 1863-1935. Mannaberg, J. Nekrolog. Wien. klin. Wschr., 1935, 48: HAMMERSCHLAG, Sigfrid, 1871- Lehrbuch der operativen Geburtshilfe. 2. Aufl. xv, 544p. roy. 8? Lpz., S. Hirzel, 1924. —— Lehrbuch der praktischen Geburtshilfe fur Studierende und Aerzte. vii, 296p. illust. 8? Stuttg., F. Enke. 1933. For lestschrift see Mschr. Geburtsh. Gyn., 1931, 87: portr. HAMMERSCHMIDT 53 HAMMON HAMMERSCHMIDT, Alfred, 1906- *Ueberblick iiber die Ergebnisse der Recurrensbe- handlung im Jahre 1925 in der- Psychiatrischen Klinik zu Jena fiinf Jahre nach Abschluss der Kur [Jena] 30p. 8? Borna, R. Noske, 1933. HAMMERSCHMIDT, Joh. Serologische Un- tersuchungstechnik; vollstandig neubearb. von P. Th. Miiller; Technik der serodiagnostischen Methoden. vi, 195p. 12? Jena, G. Fischer, 1926. HAMMERSCHMIDT, Otto, 1910- *Ueber die Genauigkeit der haptischen Ver- wirklichung geometrischer Grundbegriffe [Jena] 24p. 2 pl. 8? Zeulenroda, B. Sporn, 1934. HAMMERSCHMIDT, Wilhelm. *Ueber die Morphium-Chloralhydrat- und die Morphium- Urethan-Narkose bei intravenoser Injection [Bern] 28p. 8? Berl., L. Schumacher, 1910. Also Zschr. exp. Path. Ther., 1910, 8: HAMMERSMITH, England. West London Hospital [Instituted May, 1856; opened July, 1856] Annual report. Hammersmith, 23.-41., 1879-97; 43.-49., 1899-1905; 53.-58., 1909-14; 62.-63., 1918-19. HAMMERSMITH, Eng. See also London. Clippingdale, S. D. Hammersmith doctors at the end of the eighteenth century. West Lond. M. J., 1915, 20: 104. HAMMER-TOE. See Finger; Toe. HAMMES, Josef, 1909- Untersu- chungen iiber die Temperaturempfindung im Trigeminusgebiete nach Alkoholinjektion. 27p. 8? Bonn, H. Trapp, 1935. HAMMES, Wilhelm, 1909- *Kritisch- Kasuistisches uber 100 Falle von Kohlenoxyd- Vergiftungen [Munchen] 40p. 8? Speyer, Pilger, 1936. HAMMETT, Frederick S[imonds] 1885- The influence of sulfhydryl on cell proliferation and its possible significance in the cancer prob- lem. 8p. roy. 8? [n. p., n. pub., 1934] ---- The nature of growth; a logistic inquiry. 59p. 8? Provincetown, Mass. [n. pub.] [1936] For portrait, photograph see collection in library. HAMMOMYIA. See also FIv. Copeman, S. M. Note on the capture (in London) of a rare parasitic fly, Hammomyia (Hylephila) unilineata Zett. Proc. Zool. Soc, Lond., 1921, 31-4. HAMMOND, Bayard Louis, 1900- *De- velopment and regeneration of Podostemon ceratophyllum [Johns Hopkins University] v. p. illust. 8? Bait., 1936-37. Reprinted from Bull. Torrey Bot. Club, 1937, 64: & Bot. Gaz., 1936, 97: HAMMOND, George F. A treatise on hos- pital and asylum construction; with special reference to pavilion wards, v.l. 7 p. 1. 172p. xi, 8? Clevel. [n. pub.] 1891. HAMMOND, Graeme Monroe, 1858- See Hammond, William A., & Hammond, G. M. A treatise on the diseases of the nervous system. 9. ed. 9d-*p. 8. N. Y., 1898. HAMMOND, J., & HALNAN, E. T. A course of practical physiology for agricultural students. 106p. 8? Cambr., Univ. Press, 1920. HAMMOND, John. FecundaciOn artificial. 24p. illust. 8? B. Air., Univ. Buenos Aires, Forms Bol. No. 10, Univ. Buenos Aires, Facultad de Agro- nomia y Veterinaria. HAMMOND, Thomas Edwin, 1888- The constitution and its reaction in health, ix, 160p. 8? Lond., H. K. Lewis & co., 1934. ---- Principles in the treatment of inflamma- tion, xii, 209p. 8? Lond., H. K. Lewis & co., 1934. ----Infections of the urinary tract, x, 250p. 8? Lond., H. K. Lewis & co., 1935. ---- Vitality and energy in relation to the constitution, xi, 314p. 8? Lond., H. K. Lewis & co., 1936. HAMMOND, William Alexander, 1828-1900. On certain conditions of nervous derangement, somnambulism, hypnotism, hysteria, hysteroid affections [&c] 256p. 8? N. Y., G. P. Put- nam's Sons, 1881. ---- Doctor Grattan. 417p. 8? N. Y., D. Appleton co., 1885. ---- Cerebral hyperaemia, the result of mental strain or emotional disturbance, the so- called nervous postration or neurasthenia. 2. ed. 118p. 16? Wash., Brentano's, 1895. See also [The William A. Hammond case, late Surgeon General, U. S. A., comments on the medical and surgical history of the Civil War, the Index Catalogue 1873, American surgery, the Medical Museum [&c] 50 1. sm. 4? [n. p., n. pub.] 1873-75. Also Duncan, L. C. The da3rs gone by; the strange case of Surgeon General Hammond. Mil. Sur- geon, 1929, 44: 98; 252. For biography see Army M. Bull., 1940, 52: 42-6, portr. (J. M. Phalen) For portrait see Pennsylvania Health, 1941-42, 2: 18. --- & HAMMOND, Graeme M. A treatise on the diseases of the nervous system. 9. ed. 2 1. 932D. illust. 8? N. Y., D. Appleton & co., 1898 HAMMOND'S disease. See Athetosis. HAMMURABI. See also Babylonia. Carleton, P. The code of Hammurabi. In his Buried Empires, N. Y., 1939, 253-63.—Letienne, A. La medecine au 20me si£cle avant notre fire (le code de Hammourab) Presse med., 1906, 14: 273-5. HAMNE [Paul] Bertil, 1902- Studien uber die Biologie des C-Vitamins mit besonderer Berucksichtigung des Kohlehydratstoffwechsels. 259p. 6 pl. 24cm. Stockh., O. L. Svanbacks, 1941. Forms Suppl. 4, v.28, Acta paediat. HAMON, Henry, 1910- *Valeur alimen- taire et therapeutique de la pomme, du jus de pommes et du cidre [Paris] 62p. 8? Domfront, Impr. Pub. de L'Orne, 1937. HAMON, Henri, 1914- *Sur un cas de syndrome hypophysaire; contribution a ^l'etude de la roentgentherapie dans la c6cit<§ d'origine infundibulo-tub6rienne. 77p. 25cm. Par., J. Haumont, 1939. HAMON, Jean, 1617-87. Grimbert. C. Un medecin mystique au WI« siecle: M. Hamon, medecin et solitaire de Port-Royal. Bull. Soc. fr. hist. m<5d 1925 19: 86-90.—Jean Hamon, medecin de Port-Hoyal. Rev."gen. clin. ther., 1937, 51: SuppL I173.-Levy-Valensi, J. Monsieur Hamon, medecin de Port-Royal. Sem. hop. Pans, 1928, 4:468-92. HAMON, Louis Ernest, 1904- *Laryngo- scopie directe et aspiration dans le croup et la diphterie tracheo-bronchique de l'enfance. 91p. pl 8? Par., Jouve & cie, 1933. HAMON, Marcel, 1906- Contributions a l'etude des lesions buccales au cours de la leucemie aigue. 46p. 8? Par., A. Legrand, 1932. HAMON 54 HAMSUT HAMON, Yves, 1912- *Un cas de guerison d'une pdritonite streptococcique primi- tive. 54p. 8? Par., M. Vigne, 1938. HAMONET, Henry, 1911- *Les septi- cemics a staphylocoques; contribution a l'etude du traitement par l'anatoxine staphylococcique de Ramon. 63p. 8? Par., L. Arnette, 1938. HAMONIAIX, Jean, 1910- *Des erreurs des statistiques du cancer. 74p. 8? Par., Jouve & cie, 1936. HAMOULI, Mohamed A. el, 1897- *Beitrage zur Symptomatologie und Therapie der Blasenspalte [Berlin] 23p. 8? Charlottenb., Gebr. Hoffmann, 1627. HAMPE, Hanns, 1910- *Zur hormonalen Behandlung von Zyklusstorungen. 68p. 23?2cm. Berl., E. Wernitz, 1938. HAMPE, Wilhelm [Erich Kurt] 1908- * Experimentelle Untersuchungen iiber die Wir- kungen des Dentinanasthetikums Dentamo auf die Sensibilitat des Dentins und die Vitalitat der Zahnpulpa [Halle] 16p. 8? Bleicherode, C. Nieft, 1934. HAMPEL, Eberhard, 1907- ♦Bezie- hungen zwischen Diabetes mellitus und Gallen- erkrankungen [Wurzburg] 18p. 8? Dillingen a. Donau, 1930. HAMPEL, Erich [Albert Artur Gustav] 1896- *Ueber Eosinophilic mit besonderer Be- riicksichtigung und mit Untersuchungen bei Rheumatismus [Leipzig] 73p. 8? Staffelstein, Felgenauer & Schuster, 1922. HAMPEL, Erwin, 1893- *Ueber Wesen, Ursachen und physikalische Behandlung der Omarthritis [Berlin] 41p. 8? [Soldin, n. pub.] 1926. HAMPEL, Georg [Bruno Karl] 1905- *Zwei Falle einer Keratosis verrucosa Weiden- feld [Munchen] 20p. pl. 8? Giinzb., K. Mayer, 1935. HAMPEL, Hanns [Paul Josef] 1892- *Ueber Schweinerotlauf beim Menschen unter besonderer Berucksichtigung der septischen Form, des generalisierten Schweinerotlaufs [Greifs- wald] 31p. 8? Rheydt, O. Berger [1929] HAMPEL, Karl, 1910- *Ueber bakterio- logische Befunde in Leichenorganen mit beson- derer Berucksichtigung der Anaerobier. 28p 8? Bresl., K. Vater, 1938. HAMPEL, Karl Heinz, 1910- *Beitrag zur Epidemiologie und Klinik der Tuberkulosis verrucosa cutis. 23p. 22>^cm. Bresl., R. Nischkowsky, 1937. HAMPEL, Ludwig, 1893- *Beitrag zum Hydrocephalus und seiner Bedeutung bei Seh- storungen. 39p. 8? Bresl. [n. pub.] 1926 HAMPEL, Symcha, 1913- *La sedi- mentation sanguine, reaction de Biernacki, par centrifugation, technique de MM. J. Barbier et G. Piquet. 55p. 25cm. Lyon, Paquet, 1938. HAMPERL, Herwig. Editor of Ribbert, H. Lehrbuch der allgemeinen Patho- logieundderpathologischen Anatomie. 12. Aufl 634d 25cm Berl., 1939. P" " HAMPL, Roswitha, 1909- *Die Wirkung der aktiven Silberfliissigkeit nach Kruse-Fischer auf Aphanozoen [Leipzig] 8p. 8? Zeulenroda A. Oberreuter, 1934. HAMPSTEAD, Eng. Mount Vernon Hospital for Consumption and Diseases of the Chest. Annual reports. Hampstead, 42.-51., 1901-lo' HAMSIK, Antonin, 1878- .ek^Sm^: .ill"40''1" H^^-^narian] Cas. HAMSUT, Knut, 1859- Sperber, M. [Biography] Internat. Zschr. Individual- psychol., Wien, 1929, 7: 147-9. HAMULUS. See Cochlea; Lacrimal bone; Pterygoid. HAMVAS, Istvan Gyorgy. *Die physio- pathologischen Grundlagen der psychischen Ver- iinderungen bei postencephalitischen Zustanden. 56p. 23cm. Stetten-Basel, K. Schahl, 1939. HAMY, Ernest Theodore Jules, 1842-1908. Houze. E. Biographic Bull. Soc. anthrop. Bruxelles, 1909, 28: 43-56, portr. HAMY, Georges, 1909- Contribution a l'etude de Taxation des locaux d'habitation et de reunion. 32p. 23cm. Par., A. Lapied, 1939. HANACK, Kaethe, 1908- *Ueber einen seltenen Fall von kombinierter Hemmungs- missbildung. 24p. 8? Berl. [n. pub.] 1936. HANAK, Antonin, 1889-1935. Hons, V. [Obituary] Bratisl. lek. listy, 1935, 15: 153-6 portr.— Karasek, F. [Obituary] Cas. lek. cesk., 1935. 74: 1015-7, portr. HANAN, Giorgio, 1870-1938. Necrolcgia. Gazz. osp., 1938, 59: 197. HANANIA, Anvar, 1908- *Sur les indi- cations et le traitement operatoires des kystes hydatiques du poumon. 94p. 8? Par., Jouve & cie, 1935. HANANIA, Ishaq, 1906- *Contribution a l'application du cloisonnement dlargi du vagin a tous les degr<5s du prolapsus genital. 69p. 3 pl. 24Hcm. Par., J. Haumont, 1938. HANAU, Rudolph L. Hanau intraoral method vs Gysi extraoral method. 82p. 12? Buffalo, N. Y. [1927] Dental engineering, v.l, pt 2. ---- Full denture prosthesis; intraoral tech- nique for Hanau articulator model H. 4. ed. 83p. 8? [Buffalo, n. pub., 1930] HANAUER, Herbert, 1911- *Agranulo- zytose als Folge einer Paradentitis pyorrhoica [Frankfurt a. M.] 15p. 8? Wurzb., K. Roll, 1936. HANAUER, Wilhelm, 1901- *Ein Fall von einer isolierten zeitlichen Luxation der Ulna am distalen Ende. 8p. 8? Giessen [n. pub.] 1925. P HANAUT, Andre, 1909- Contribution a l'Stude de l'acrodynie infantile. 167p. 8? Par., A. Legrand, 1937. HANAWALT, Nelson Gilbert, 1906- * Memory trace for figures in recall and recogni- tion [Columbia Univ.] 89p. illust. tab. ch. 8? N. Y., 1937. Forms No. 216, Arch. Psychol., June 1937. HANCE, Robert T[heodore] 1892- Visual outline of zoology, lllp. 8? N. Y., Longmans, Green & Co. [1937] HANCHELT, Juliet, 1856-1921. MedI°Woen;,an-JMi92T3he30h:iS8t9Ory °f ^^ ^^ W°m6n- HANCHETT, Henry G[ranger] 1853- bexual health; a companion to Modern domestic practice. 86p. 12? N. Y., C. T. Hurlburt, —— Elements of modern domestic medicine. 2 ed. 377p. 8? Phila., Hahnemann Pub. House, 1891. ."fCKEN, Christian W. *Dealin, ein neues TSetSrO. ^"^ 36P- 8? BerL> R" ^p^NtS°CK', A- R-- Reminiscences of Winfield Scott Hancock, xm 340p. pl. portr. 8? JN. l., C. L. Webster & Co., 1887. HANCOCK 55 HAND HANCOCK, George Charles, 1868- Re- port on the outbreak of illness at Poplar suspected to be due to local pollution of the water supply. 1 p. 1. 18p. 9 ch. 8? Lond., H. M. Stat. Off., 1927. Forms No. 41, Rep. Pub. Health M. Subj. ---- A report on the occurrence of glass fragments in food packed in glass containers. 2 p. 1. 36p. 8? Lond., H. M. Stat. Off., 1927. Forms No. 37, Rep. Pub. Health M. Subj. HAND. See also Arm; Carpus; Extremity, upper; Finger; Forearm; Hand and foot; Metacarpus; Thumb; Wrist. Galien. Eloge de la main. Aesculape, Par., 1934, 24: 92-5.—Gaul, J. S. The hand. South. M. & S., 1932, 94: 524.—Guisan, A. La main votive d'Avenches. Aesculape, Par., 1934, 24: 98.—Margarit, F. La mano. Siglo med., 1926, 78: 261.—Meige, H., & Bellugue, P. La main dans l'art. Aesculape, Par., 1934, 24: 50-65.—Mettenheim, H. von. Die Hand des Kindes in Gesundheit und Krankheit. Erg. ges. Med., 1935, 20: 485-510.—Ogilvie, W. H. The hand. Guy's Hosp. Gaz., Lond., 1937, 51: 114; 177.—Senkewitsch, P. I. Besteht ein Zusammenhang zwischen der morpholo- gischen Struktur und der Leistungsfahigkeit der Hand bei jugendlichen Arbeitern? Arbeitsphysiologie, 1932-33, 6: 339-52.—Wachholder, K., & Altenburger, H. Haben unsere Glieder nur eine Ruhelage? (zugleich Beitrag zur Messung der bei passiven und aktiven Bewegungen auftretenden Elastizi- tatskrafte) Arch. ges. Physiol., 1926-27, 215: 627-40. ---- Abnormity. See also subheading Deformity. Freudenberg, K. *Ein Fall von Diplo- cheirie und ein Fall von angeborener Opponens- aplasie des Daumens; die atiologische Bedeutung des Amnion bei der Genese dieser Missbildungen [Kiel] 37p. 8? Hamb., 1935. Muller, W. Die angeborenen Fehlbildungen der menschlichen Hand; Erb- und Konstitutions- biologie der Hand. 170p. 8? Lpz., 1937. Selmayr, A. *Die radio-ulnare Synostose, verbunden mit anderen angeborenen Miss- bildung an der Hand. 15p. 23J^cm. Miinch. [1936] Apfelthaller, M. Drei Falle von angeborenen Missbildungen der Hand. Virchows Arch., 1926, 262: 565-71.—Bernsten, A. Drei Falle von Manus vara congenita ohne Defekt der Vorder- armknochen. Acta chir. scand., 1930, 67: 61-7.—Boorstein, S. W. Cleft hand; report of a ease. J. Bone Surg., 1930, 12: 172-6. Also repr.-—Brites, G. Syndactylie totale et hypo- phalangie de la main (main en bee de cuiller) Fol. anat. Univ. conimbr., 1930, 5: No. 7-8, 1-5, 2 pl.—Cardi, G. Considera- zioni sopra un caso di malformazione congenita della mano. Arch, ortop., Milano, 1937, 18: 427-34.—Carnevali, S. L. Sulla deviazione congenita ulnare delle dita. Ibid., 1938, 54: 845-51.—Craig, A. L. Two cases of unusual congenital de- formities. J. Bone Surg., 1932, 14: 188.—Dombrowski, A. Ein Fall von Megalosyndaktylie. Munch, med. Wschr., 1928, 75: 1503.—Fuchs, B. I. [Elbow parva manus] Nov. khir. arkh., 1937, 39: 125-9.—Funston, R. V. The relation of congenital deformities of the hand to cervical ribs. J. Am. M. Ass., 1932, 98: 697-700. Also repr.—Gillette, C. P. An inheritable defect of the human hand. J. Hered., 1931, 22: 189-90.—Hilgers, J. Ein Beitrag zur Erbbiologie der seltenen angeborenen Korperfehler an den Gliedmassen. Zschr. Orthop., 1935-36, 64: 288-98.—Hissard, R. Infantilisme asymetrique des doigts; infantilisme apparent des doigts; infantilisme reel des metacarpiens. Bull. Soc. fr. derm, syph., 1935, 42: 1831- 5.—Hottinger, A. Beitrag zur Klinik der angeborenen Haltungs- anomalien infolge muskularer Kontrakturen: Klumphand, Schiefhals, Kniegelenkskontrakturen. Jahrb. Kinderh., 1926, 3. F., 62: 258-71.—Ipertrofla congenita di due dita della mano d. (I e II) e dell'eminenze tenare. Riforma med., 1935, 51: 1453.—Juaristi & Arraiza. Sobre la mano zamba. Arch. espafi. pediat., 1928, 12: 154-7.—Kanavel, A. B. Congenital malformations of the hands. Arch. Surg., 1932, 25: 1; 282. Also repr.-—Karlin, V. N. [On monstrosities in connection with the description of two congenital monsters: manus parva; syndactilia et ektrodactilia] Med. obozr., Moskva, 1911, 76: 948-52.—Katzenstein-Sutro, E. Beobachtungen und Betrachtungen iiber Formabweichungen an den Handen. Helvet. med. acta, 1938, 5: 135-54.—Kerr, A. A. Malforma- tions of the hand with report of a case of double thumb. Tr. West. Surg. Ass. (1922) 1923, 32: 33-40—Lasserre, C. Hyper- trophic congenitale de la main avec clinodactylie. J. med. Bordeaux, 1926, 56: 841.—Longhi, L. Malformazioni con- genite delle mani; tentativo di classificazione e contributo casistico. Arch, ortop., Milano, 1939, 55: 183-212.—Luiz de Pifla. Les anomalies de la main et la morphologie des cretes papillaires. Anthropologie, Par., 1939, 49: 55-71.—Macchioro, G. Un caso di aplasia parziale del costato destro con ipotrofia e sindattilia della mano corrispondente. Radiol, med., Milano, 1931, 18: 37-42.—McMurtrie, K. F. A case of congenital hypertrophy of the right hand. J. Trop. M. Hyg., Lond., 1932, 35: 343-5.—Meschaninov, A. [Inborn crook-hands; case] Vrach. delo, 1927, 10: 1000.—Meyerding, H. W., & Dickson, D. D. Correction of congenital deformations of the hand. Am. J. Surg., 1939, 44: 218-31.—Ox, A. [Svndrome of acro- micria] Vrach. gaz., 1928, 32: 738-41.—Pichon, E., & Wirz, S. Malformations congenitales multiples, main a 5 doigts sans pouce. Bull. Soc. p6diat. Paris, 1936, 34: 310.—Popenoe, P. Split-hand. J. Hered., 1937, 28: 174-6.—Ptic, D. [Congenital deformities of the hand] Polski przegl. radjol., 1935-36, 10-11: 65-70, 2 pl.—Rocher, Forton & Gucrin. Quatre cas de malformation congenitale de la main. J. med. Bordeaux, 1928, 58: 257-60.—Rocher, H. L., Secousse & Pouyanne, L. Hypertrophic congfinitale de 2 doigts (I et II) et de l'eminence thenar. Ibid., 19.35, 112: 395.—Rcederer. Absence congenitale de la lignge radiale; main composee d'un seul doigt. Bull. Soc. pediat. Paris, 1926, 24: 147.—Rogers, L. Maldevelop- ment of the wrist and hand. Edinburgh M. J., 1925, n. ser., 32: 407-9.—Salazar de Sousa, C. Dois tipos raros de ano- malias congenitas da mao. Arq. anat., 1929-30, 13: 119-28.— Schatzki, P. Ueber verdeckte syndaktyle Polydaktylie und iiber Triangelbildung in der menschlichen Mittelhand. Arch. orthop. UnfaUchir., 1933-34, 34: 637-52.—Shore, L. R. A case of multiple anomaly of the phalanges of the hands in a girl aged 15. J. Anat., Lond., 1925-26, 60: 420-5.—Stacey, R. S. A rare malformation of the hand. Ibid., 1937-38, 72: 456, pl.—Szepsenwol, J., & Genequand, B. A propos d'une anomalie exceptionnelle et symetrique dans l'innervation et la vascularisation de la face dorsale de la main. Ann. anat. path., Par., 1935, 12: 610-7.—Tatafiore, E. Su di un raro tipo di malformazione congenita della mano destra. Pediatria. (Riv.) 1932, 40: 829.—Viotti, M. Vicios de conformacao das maos. Arq. med. leg. ident., Rio, 1934, No. 10, 194-9, 8 pl. ---- Abnormity: Talipomanus. Buizard, C. Transmission h6r6ditaire, pendant plusieurs generations, d'une double main bote cubitale pure. Bull. Soc. chir. Paris, 1928, 20: 711-4.—Davidson, A. J., & Horwitz, M. T. Congenital club-hand deformity associated with ab- sence of radius; its surgical correction, a case report. J. Bone Surg., 1939, 21: 402.—Elterich, T. O. Talipomanus (Con- genital club hand) Atlantic M. J., 1927-28, 31: 953.—Forbes, G. A case of congenital clubhand with a review of the aeti- ology of the condition. Anat. Rec, 1938, 71: 181-99.— Grizaud, H. Sur un cas de main bote congenitale bilaterale. J. radiol. electr., 1932, 16: 515.—Gruca, A. Un cas de main bote cubito-palmaire congenitale avec subluxation des pha- langes. Rev. orthop.,Par., 1927, 3. ser., 14: 407-12.—Jonck- heere, F. Main bote acquise; resultat eioigne apres correction. J. traumat., Brux., 1940, 4: 151-8.—Jones, H. W., & Roberts, R. E. A rare type of congenital club hand. J. Anat., Lond., 1925-26, 60: 146.—Martmer, E. E. Talipomanus: a report of 3 cases in one family. Am. J. Dis. Child., 1927, 34: 384-7 — Oberthur. Chirurgie des mains botes traumatiques. Rev. orthop., Par., 1938, 3. ser., 25: 56-61.—Parahy, G. Une technique chirurgicale de la main bote. Rev. techn. chir., Par., 1932, 24: 27-32.—Reschke, K. Zur operativen Be- handlung der erworbenen Klumphand. Deut. Zschr. Chir., 1931, 232: 458-62.—Rocher, H. L. Main bote radio-palmaire par absence totale du rayon radial; h6matocolpos et h6mato- metrie. Arch, electr. med., 1925, 35: 29-33. ------ Main bote congenitale et main bote paralytique. Gaz. sc. med. Bordeaux, 1925, 46: 677; 693; 707. Also Vie med., 1925, 6: 1885-7.------Main bote cubito-palmaire gauche avec cubitus valgus, paralysie faciale totale gauche et pied bot varus equin droit d'origine congenitale. J. med. Bordeaux, 1925, 55: 737. ------ Main bote radio-palmaire trau- matique, avec perte du pouce, radius brevis et inflexion distale des diaphyses radiale et cubitale; rendement fonctionnel interessant. Ibid., 1935, 112: 186. ----— & Rocher, C. Double main bote radiale congenitale, compliquee dans un cas de luxation du coude, dans l'autre de luxation de l'epaule. Ibid., 880-2. ---- Amputation. Winter, R. *Ueber die Krukenberg-Hand [Bonn, 1929] 41p. 8? Diisseldorf [1930] Balanzario, I. Condiciones de la cirugia mutilante; opera- ci6n de Krukenberg; ligera modificaci6n. Rev. cir. Hosp. Juarez, M6x., 1934, 5: 95-9.—Colp, R., & Ransohoff, N. S. The Krukenberg stump. J. Bone Surg., 1933, 15: 439-43 — Delitala. Le amputazioni parziali della mano. Chir. org. movim., 1917, 1: 595-636, 52 fig. ------ Nuovo contributo alio studio delle amputazioni parziali della mano considerate in rapporto alia protesi. Ibid., 1919, 3: 115-21.—Dupuy de Frenelle. Amputation de la main. Techn. chir., Par., 1935, 27: 109-22.—Garcia Diaz, F. Cinematizaci6n; contribuci6n a la casuistica de metacarpolisis, por mutilaci6n del pulgar y pinza de Krukenberg, en los amputados de antebrazo. Sem. med., B. Air., 1938, 45: 658-60.—Henry, A. K. An operation for making the forearm prehensile after loss of a hand. Brit. HAND 56 HAND J. Surg., 1928-29, 16: 188-97. Reconstruction of the forearm after amputation of the hand. Brit. M. J., 1931, 1 393-5.—Iusevich, M. S. [Methods in the application of Filatov's flap in plastic operations of the stumps of the hand and finger.-] Ortop. travmat., 1940, 14: No. 3, 50-6. - Kruken- berg, H. Erfahrungen mit der Krukenberg-Hand. Arch. klin. Chir., 1931, 165: 191-201.—Kuzmik, P. Amputation der Hand. Rapp. Congr. Soc. internat. chir., 1914, 3. Congr., 2i_7—Patrick, J. Demonstration of patient operated on by Lister in 1870. Tr. R. Med. Chir. Soc. Glasgow, 1921, 14: 60.—Puree, T. Notes on a successful case of Krukenbeig s operation. Brit. J. Surg., 1939-40, 27: 419-21—Squires, 11. T. Note on 2 cases of Krukenberg's operation. Ibid., 1937 38, 25: 404-6.- Vincent, W. G. Amputation of hand except thumb after compound fracture of metacarpals, with gas bacillus infection. Med. Rec, N. Y., 1918. 91: 1006.—Voro- biev, N. A. [Operation for Krukenberg's hand] Ortop. travmat., 1936, 10: 54-9. ---- Anatomy. Bayer, L. M.. & Grav. H. Hand size in working women- Human Biol.. 1930. 8: 207--72.—Garcia Luquero, C. Distri- bucion arterial y nerviosa de la mano. Progr. clin., Madr., 1916, 8: 195.—Iselin, M. Anatomie chirurgicale des espaces cellulcux de la main i-t des doigts. Arm. anat. path., Par., 1927,4:603-13. ------& Evrard, H. Etude anatomique des espaces celluleux de la main. Ibid., 1932, 9: 37-62.—Kajava, Y. Die volare Handmuskulatur der Huftiere: vergleichend- anatomische Untersuchungen. Acta Soc. med. Duodecim, 1923, 4: H. 1, 1-184, 10 pl. Koenner. D. M. Ein Beitrag zur Morphologie der Hand. Verh. Deut. Ges. liassenforsch., 1938, 9: 62-8, 4 pl.—Mondio, V. Rilievi statistici sulle dimension! della mano nell'uomo. Monit. zool. ital., 1934, 45: Suppl. 213-7. ---- Anthropology. Dyckhoff, B. *Anthropologische Unter- suchungen iiber die Hand des Sauglings und seiner Eltern. 17p. 8? Koln, 1936. Bavor. L. M.. & Gray. H. The hand: method of measure- ment.' Am. J. I'hvs. Anthrop., 1933, 17: 379-415.—Freund, L. Das anatomische Subst.rat des Schattenbildes der menschlichen Hand bei Streulichtuun isuchung derselbcn. Wien. klin. Wschr., 1937, 50: Mil.- Koenner, D. M. Anthropologisehc und morphologische Beohaeht ungrn an der menschlichen Hand. Mitt. Anthrop. Ges Wien. 1938, 68: 246-63.—Nippert, O. Verschiedene Handformen. Volk A: Basse, 1934, 9: 73-9.— Schlaginhaufen, O. Zur Kenntnis der Handform der Issa- Somali. Arch. Julius Klaus StifL, 1934, 9: 205-73.—Wechsler, W. Anthropologische Untersuchung der Handform mit einem familienkundlichen Beitrag. Ibid., 1939, 14: 199-359. ---- artificial. Bonnet, R. Die Hand und ihr Ersatz. 29p. 8? Lpz., 1915. Hahner, H. *Eine Radialis-Arbeits-Schiene mit kleiner Handstiitze am Hypothenar unter Erhaltung der Greiffahigkeit aller Finger. 16p. 8? Erlanger, 1933. Alsberg, A. Ueber Arbc itsersatzstiicke bei Verlust der Greif- und Haltefahigkeit von I-'ingern und Hand. Zschr. orthop. Chir., 1928, 50: 565-70.—David, R. L. Artificial hand. U. S. Patent Off., 1940, No. 2,225,468.—Dorrance, D. W. Artificial hand. Ibid.. 1935, No. 2,010,751; 1936, No. 2,030,785.—Eberle, F. V. Artificial hand and wrist assemblv. I". S. Patent Off., 1941, No. 2,230,378—Gocke. Die mensch- liche Hand und ihr technischer Ersatz. Zschr. Kruppel- fiirs., 1928, 21: 83-92.— Hennine, F. C. Artificial hand. L. S. Patent Off., 1934. No. 1.981.098.—Nazarov, G.S. [Active, artificial han.bl Ortop. travmat., 1938, 12: No. 3, 137-42.— Saryeson. J. Hydraulic artificial hand. U. S. Patent Off., 1939, No. 2.182,214. ---- Atrophy. See also subheading Nerves: Disease. Copelovici, H. *Main plate d'Aran-Duchenne d'origine carpienne. 44p. 8? Par., 1933. Euziere, Lafon & Fassio. Atropine des eminences thenars et dorsalisation de C7. Arch. Soc. sc. med. biol. Montpellier, 1939, 20: 148.—Flatau. Demonstration eines Falles von Atrophic der kleinen Handmuskulatur. Berl. klin. Wschr., 1917, 54: 832.—Gougerot. Pardsie et atrophic musculaire de la main et avant-Was droits; anesthesie globale du membre droit; syphilis probable. Progr. med., Par., 1917, 3. ser., 32: 313.—Hunt. J. R. Thenar and hypothenar types of neural atrophy of the hand. Brit. M. J., 1930, 2: 642.—Maclean, B. Atrophy of the intrinsic muse'es of the hand. Clin. J Lond 1927. 56: 189-91- Marcus. E., & Hirsch, M. Oedem der Hand und Atrophic von kuochen des Handkelettes; peii- arterielle Sympathektcme Wien. med. Wschr., 1934, 84: 242— Oppenheimer, A. The owollen atrophic hand. Surg Gyn Ol t , 1938 67: 446-54.— Rocher, H. L., & Roux, d! Atropine congenitale de la main droitc. J. med. Bordeaux, 1934, 111: 115- Saucier, J. Syndrome d'Aron-Duchenne predominant a la main gauche. Union med. Canada, 1933, 62: 350-4. ---- Bloodvessels. Freerksen, E. *Dic Ycncn des menschlichen Handriickens [Giessen] p.82-111. 24L>cm. Berl., 1937. Also Zschr. Anat. Entw., 1937-38. 108: Barbosa Sueiro, M. B. Anotac5es anat6micas; uma dis- posiciio rara das arcadas arteriais palmares. Arq. anat., 1937, 18- 425-32 Bressou, C. Anomalies arterielles de la main chez les equides. Bee. m6d. vet., 1933, 109: 129-36- Capps, R. B. Venous tone and blood flow in the hand; with special reference to the reflex effect of a noxious stimulus. I'roc. Inst. M. Chicago, 1936, 11: 127- Cirilo, N., A: Baldesi. A. Le arcate arteriose della palma della mano; areus volaris super- ficialis et arcus volaris profundus; ricerche auatomiche e radiologiche. Prat, chir., Arezzo, 1939, 5: 248-61.—Freeksen, Tvpen und Variationen der Venen des menschlichen Hand- riickens. Verh. Anat. Ges., 1938, 45: 188-91- Freeman, N. E. The effect of temperature on the rate of blood flow m the normal and in the svmpathectomized hand. Am. J. Bhvsiol., 1935, 113: 384-98.—Nishi, S. Ueber die Arterien der Affenhand; ein Beitrag zur vorgleichendcn Angiologie. Jap. J. M. Sc, 1938-39, 7: Anat., 385-93. ---- Bloodvessels: Aneurysm. Carrasco, F. *Ueber Aneurysmen der Hohl- handarterien. 43p. 8? Berl., 1916. Kermabon, Y. Y. A. de. *Anevrysmes artenels traumatiques de la main. 60p. 24cm. Par., 1939. Thiebatjld, P. *Contribution a l'6tude des aneVrismes de l'arcade palmaire superficielle. 79p. 8? Par., 1914. Amour, D. Case of cirsoid aneurysm of the hand. Tr. M. Soc. London, 1919, 42: 237.—Andrus, W. De W. Traumatic arteriovenous fistula of the palm. Ann. Surg., 1937, 105: 466- 9.—Brechot & Reinhold. Un cas d'anevrysme de l'arcade palmaire superficielle. Progr. med., Par., 1933, 1435.— Dalche, P., & Menaud, E. Anevrysme de la paume de la main. Rev. gen. clin. ther., 1920, 34: 709.—David, V. C. Aneurysms of the hand. Arch. Surg., 1930, 33: 267-75.—Fab re, P. C, & Dambrin, P. Tumeur pseudo-anevrysmale de la main. Ann. anat. path., Par., 1935, 12: 380-3.—Ferran. Deux cas d'ane- vrysmes arteriels de la main. Arch. fr. belg. chir., 1924, 27: 159.—Frenkel, A. Ueber ein traumatisches Aneurysma des Hohlhandbogens. Zbl. Chir., 1929, 56: 3159.—Gebele, H. Spontanes arterio-venoses Aneurysma der Hand. Ibid., 1936, 63: 1520-3.—Gottesman, J. Arteriovenous aneurysm of hand. Am. J. Surg., 1936, 33: 323-25.—Kirwan, E. O G. A case of aneurysm of the superficial palmar arch. Brit. M. J., 1921, 2: 1113.—Lyle, H. H. M. Aneurysm of the palmar arches, with a report of an aneurysm of the deep arch cured by excision. Tr. Am. Surg. Ass., 1924, 42: 573-90 [Discussion] 671-9. Also Ann. Surg., 1924, 80: 347-62— Mazade, J. Observation d'anevrisme de l'arcade palmaire superficielle; cauterisation; guerison. J. med. Toulouse, 1865, 4. ser., 4: 333-6.—Michens, J. R., Mugaburu, P., & Lanardonne, C. Contribucion a] estudio de los aneurismas verdaderos de la mano. Prensa med. argent., 1936, 23: 634-8— Middleton, D. S. Occupational aneurysm of the palmar arteries. Brit. J. Surg., 1933, 21: 215-8.—Moure, P. Anevrisme cirsoide de la main, traite par I'extirpation et la coagulation diathermique. Bull. Soc. nat. chir., Par., 1934, 60: 962-4.—Rodrigues, J. Urn caso de aneurysma cirsoide da mao. Rev. med., S. Paulo, 1932-33, 16: 10-7, pl.—Todesco, J. A case of cirsoid aneurysm of palm of hand. Lancet, Bond., 1919, 2: 15.—Viannay. Un cas d'ane- vrysme cirsoide (?) de la main. Loire med., 1925, 39: 333; 462.—Volkmann, J. Ueber traumatische arterielle Aneurysmen der Hohlhandbogen. Deut. Zschr. Chir., 1930, 227: 151-69.— Wapshaw, H. A case of traumatic aneurysm of the palm. Glasgow M. J., 1936, 126: 333-5. ---- Bloodvessels: Disease. Allen, E. V. Thromboangiitis obliterans; methods of diagnosis of chronic occlusive arterial lesions distal to the wrist with illustrative cases. Am. J. M. Sc, 1929, 178: 237-44.— Barcaglia, A. Di una singolare distrofia venosa del palmo delle mani. Clinica, Bologna, 1939, 5:172-85.—Burrows, H. Paral- ysis of capillary blood-vessels of the hand following wounds of the forearm. Lancet, Lond., 1930, 2: 952-7.—Capizzano, N. Angioma gigante de la mano; roentgenterapia. Rev. med., Rosario, 1939, 13: No. 126, 1-3.—Coliez, R. Angiome caver- neux de la main chez une adulte traite par la curietherapie de surface. Gaz. med. France, 1933, cahier No. 12, 117-20 — Hueck, H. Em Fall von Phlebarteriektasie der Hand und des Unterarms. Chirurg, 1928-29, 1: 926-30.—Macaggi, G. B. Legatura dell areata palmare profonda al dorso della mano nei S,°™ e terzo spazio interosseo. Arch. ital. chir., 1921, 3: 293-304.— Popovici, V. M. [New incision for ligation of the HAND 57 HAND palmar arch] Rev. chir., Bucur., 1929, 21: 437-43.—Snyder, M. H., & Snyder, W. H., jr. Traumatic thrombosis of deep palmar vein. J. Am. M. Ass., 1938, 111: 2007-9.—Tanguy, R. Angiome de la main. Gaz. med. France, 1938, 45: radiol., 371-3. ---- Bones. See also Carpus; Metacarpus. Alexandrow, G. N. Seltener Fall von Fehlen der Finger- und Handwurzelknochen. Zbl. Chir., 1936, 63: 1110.—Barcia Goyanes, J. J. Las f6rmulas metacarpiana v digital en el hombre. Arq. anat. (1926) 1927, 10: 1-32.—Nakayama, Y. Anthropologische Studien des chinesischen Skeletes (Hand- knochen) J. Orient. M., Dairen, 1927, 7: 124-6.—Sarasin, F. Die Variationen im Bau des Handskeletts verschiedener Men- schenformen. Zschr. Morph. Anthrop., 1932, 30: 252-316, 3 pl.—Serrano. J. A. Estudos de osteologia; sobre a descricao dos ossos da mao. Arq. anat., 1937, 18: 229-418.—Siegert. Extremste Konkordanz der Handskelette einer Schwester, extremste Diskordanz der andern. Fortsch. Rontgenstrahl., 1937, 56: 439-43.—Stettner, E. Ossificationsstudien am Handskelet; die physiologische Wellenbewegung der Differen- zierung; die Beziehung Wuchsfoini/Differenzicrung; die Prognostik der Kbrpergrosse: das Metakarpale. Zschr. Kinderh., 1931, 51: 435-58. ---- Bones: Disease. Adams, C. O. Multiple epiphyseal anomalies in the hands of a patient with Legg-Perthes' disease. J. Bone Surg., 1937, 19: 814-16.—Bergeret, P. M. Malformations congenitales des extremites, os transversal de la main. Rev. orthop., Par., 1926, 3. ser., 13: 47-52.—Bergerhoff, W. Fraktur des Os naviculare manus sin. oder angeborene Missbildung. Ront- genpraxis, 1935, 7: 544-6.—Dupas, J., Badelon, P., & Dayde, G. Aspects radiologiques d'une osteolyse essentielle progressive de la main gauche. J. radiol. 61ectr., 1936, 20: 383-7. ------ Osteolyse essentielle progressive de la main gauche d'origine indeterminee. Mem. Acad, chir., Par., 1936, 62: 148-58 — Francais & Bouroullec. Osteomyeiite atypique, a localisations multiples, secondaire a une arthrite suppuree metacarpo- phalangienne. Bull. Soc. chir. Paris, 1938, 30: 149-56.— Guszich, A. [Roentgenographic features of osteitis of the bones o hand] Orvoskepzes, 1934, 24: 976-81, 3 pl.—Kloiber, H. Symmetrische Epiphysenerkrankung der Hande. Fortsch. Rontgenstrahl., 1926, 34: 500-6.—Koch, S. L. Osteomvelitis of the bones of the hand. Surg. Gyn. Obst., 1937, 64: i-8.— Laqua. Multiple Epiphvsenstorungen an den Handen. Beitr, klin. Chir., 1928-29, 145: 670-2.—McKim, L. H. Conserva- tivism in the treatment of infective bone lesions of the fingers. Canad. M. Ass. J., 1930, 23: 642-4.—Mauclaire. Epiphysite des tetes metacarpiennes avec main un peu creuse. Bull. Soc. nat. chir., Par., 1927, 53: 1377.—Mouchet, A. A propos de l'osteolyse essentielle progressive de la main gauche, com- munique a l'Academie en 1936, par MM. J. Dupas, P. Badelon et G. Dayde (Marine) Mem. Acad, chir., Par., 1939, 65: 166-70.—Rougemont, de. Ost6omyeiite primitive de la phlange moyenne du medius droit chez un adolescent. Lyon chir., 1933, 30: 721-4.—Roux, J. Huit observations con- cernant la pathologie des metacarpiens et des phalanges. Rev. med. Suisse rom., 1934, 54: 679-87, 10 pl.—Tanaka, T. Statistical observation of 42 cases of the Kienbock's disease. Jap. J. M. Sc, 1934-36, 4: Surg. &c, 322.—Votta, E. A. Ostei- tis fibroide de falange; su tratamiento. Rev. As. med. argent., 1940, 54:299-302. ---- Bones: Fracture. Adams, B. S. Fractures of bones of hand and fingers. Minnesota M., 1929, 12: 515-20.—Cahill, J. A. Fractures of the hand and wrist. J. Iowa M. Soc, 1931, 21: 549.— Cavalcanti, J. Sobre fraturas das falanges dos quirodaetilos. Arq. brasil. cir., 1939, 7: 326-37 —Clarke, H. O. 1'iactures of the metacarpals and phalanges. In Cvclop. Med. (Piersol- Bortz) Phila., 1939, 6: 557-63.—FritzelI. K. Fractures of the metacarpals and phalanges. Minnesota M., 1939, 22: 867-9.— Lamare, J. P. Fractures fermees du poignet. Bull, med., Par., 1937, 51: Suppl. No. 49.—McNealy, R. W., & Liechten- stein, M. E. Fractures of the metacarpals and phalanges. Tr. West. Surg. Ass., 1934, 44: 297-310. Also Surg. Gyn. Obst., 1932, 55: 758-61. Also West. J. Surg., 1935, 43: 156-61. ------ Fractures of the bones of the hand. Am. J. Surg., 1940, 50: 563-70.—Magnuson, P. B. Fractures of metacarpals and phalanges. J. Am. M. Ass., 1928, 91: 1339.— Murray, C. R. Fractures of the bones of the hand. N. York State J. M., 1936, 36: 1749-61.—Owen, H. R. Fractures of the bones of the hand. Surg. Gyn. Obst., 1938, 66: 500-5 — Petridis, P. Fracture du trapeze. Rev. orthop., Par., 1939, 3. ser., 26: 149-51.-—Roberts, N. Fractures of the phalanges of the hand and metacarpals. Proc. R. Soc. M., Lond., 1937-38, 31: 793-8, 2 pl.-—Tisdale, A. A. The more common fractures of the bones of the hand. N. Orleans M. & S. J., 1939-40, 92: 356-9.—Wier, C. K. Fractures of the metacarpals and the phalanges. J. Kansas M. Soc, 1938, 39: 501-4. ---- Bones: Fracture: Treatment. Benedict, S. R. The slipper cast. Internat. J. M. & S., 1932, 45: 524.—Carr, R. W. A finger caliper for reduction of phalangeal and metacarpal fractures by skeletal traction. South. M. J„ 1939, 32: 543-6.—Davis. G. G. A ball splint for hand fractures. Internat. Clin., 1928, 28. ser., 1: 182, 8 pl.—Fenger, M. [Treatment of fractures of fingers, meta- carpus and wrist-joint] Ugeskr. lceger, 1931, 93: 169-73.— Foster, A. K., jr. Simple standard apparatus for treatment of compound fractures of the hand, fingers and wrist; report of a case and evaluation of the end result. Arch. Surg., 1939, 39: 214-30.—Kanavel, A. B. The dynamics of the functions of the hand, with considerations as to methods of obtaining the position of function by splints. Med. J. Australia, 1927, 2: 598-602.—Kaplan, L. The treatment of fractures and dis- locations of the hand and fingers; technic of unpadded casts for carpal, metacarpal, and phalangeal fractures. Surg. Clin. N. America, 1940. 20: 1695-1720.—Lange, F. Die Behandlung der Knochenbruche durch den praktischen Arzt auf Grund orthopadischer Erfahrungen dargcstellt; Briiche der Hand und Finger. Munch, med. Wschr., 1925, 72: 1522-4.—Leser, A. J. Eine Schiene zur unblutigen Extension und Ruhigstellung von Finger- und Mittelhandbriichen. Zbl. Chir., 1936, 63: 795-7.—Meltzer, H. Die Behandlung von Finger- und Mittelhandbriichen. Chirurg, 1932, 4: 58-64. ------ Wire extension treatment of fractures of fingers and metacarpal bones. Surg. Gyn. Obst., 1932, 55: 87-9.—Monteith, W. B. R. A useful splint for fractures of the hand bones. Med. Press & Circ, Lond., 1934, 189: 342—Schaffer. Ein neuer Weg in der Hand- und Fingerbehandlung. Wien. med. Wschr., 1926, 76: 174.—Schum, H. Weitere Erfahrungen uber die Briiche der Hand- und Fingerknochen. Deut. Zschr. Chir., 1925, 193: 132-9.—Sheridan, W. J. Principles in the treatment of frac- tures of the small bones of the hand. J. Tennessee M. Ass., 1938, 31: 263-71.—Steber, F. Vereinfachte Fingerdraht- extension; zur Behandlung der Mittelhand- und Mittelfuss- knochenbriiche, auch Finger- und Zehenbruche mit starker Bruchstiickverschiebuna. Munch, med. Wschr., 1938, 85: 480.—Wertheim, W. A new type of splint for fractures of bones of the hand. J. Am. M. Ass., 1929, 92: 2171.—Wink, A. Ueber die Behandlung veralteter Bennetscher Frakturen. Mschr. Unfallh., 1936, 43: 428-31. ---- Bursae. Hayden J. G. Traumatic bursitis of right palmar bursa. Surg. Clin. N. America, 1923, 3: 1620-3.—Howard, N. J. Subcutaneous dorsal digital bursitis. Surgery, 1939, 5: 939- 41.—Rycroft, B. W. An occupational bursa of the hand Brit. M. J., 1927, 1: 280. ---- Cancer. See also subheading Sarcoma. Habrock, W. *Karzinome der Hand [Mun- ster] 27p. 21cm. Bottrop i. W., 1938. Adair, F. E. Epitheliomas of the hand: tvpes and treat- ment. Surg. Clin. N. America, 1933, 13: 423-30.—Barbry, P. Epitheiiome pagetoide du dos de la main. J. sc. med., Lille, 1925, 43: pt 2, 21-5.—Bordier, H. Cancer de la main chez un radiologiste gu6ri par la diathermo-coagulation. Cancer, Brux., 1927, 4: 328-30.—Duvoir, M., & Abecasis, A. Epi- thelioma malpighien post-traumatique precoce. Ann. med. leg., 1934, 14: 833-6.—Epstein, A. A. Zur Frage des pro- fessionellen Krebses der Hande. Zbl. Gewerbehyg., 1930, n. F., 7: 256-63.—Gougerot & Meyer, J. Epithelioma spino- cellulare consecutif a la piqure par une echarde de bronze du dos de la main souilie d'huile de machine. Bull. Soc. fr. derm. syph., 1935, 42: 278.—Kime, E. N. Carcinoma of the hand. Med. Arts, 1934, 37: 214-7.—Laurent, C. Cancer du dos de la main traite par l'eiectrocoagulation. Loire med., 1931, 45: 184.—Lemaitre, Nuytten & Dancourt, R. Un cas de cancer aigu traumatique. Echo med. nord, 1934, 3. ser., 2: 61.— Mason, M. L. Carcinoma of the hand. Arch. Surg., 1929, 18: 2107-58.—Nicolas, J., Massia, G., & Weigert, H. Epi- thelioma spino-cellulaire du dos de la main avec cicatrisation centrale spontanee. Bull. Soc. fr. derm, syph., 1931, 38: 484—6.—Ochsner, E. H. X-ray carcinoma of both hands. Tr. South. Surg. Ass., 1935, 47: 81-4. Also Am. J. Surg., 1935, 28: 273-6.—Pautrier, L. M. Epithelioma metatypique du dos de la main 6voluant depuis plusieurs annees et a type histologiquement squirrheux. Bull. Soc. fr. derm, syph., 1936, 43: 1739-45.—Petges, G., Petges, A., & Dubarry. Epithelioma spinocellulare du dos de la main. J. med. Bordeaux, 1934, 111: 141.—Piga, A., & Ferran, A. Los epiteliomas de la mano y su tratamiento. Progr. clin., Madr., 1919, 13: 5-20, pl.— Ramos e Silva, J. Sobre os epiteliomas cutaneos do dorso das maos; seu diagn6stico. Arch. Inst. Benjamin Baptista, Rio, 1938, 4: 139-47.—Roux, J. N. Observation sur une tumeur cancereuse. Observ. sc. med., 1823, 5: 129-33.—Sergi, V. Sopra un caso di miasi da Sarcophaga caranria in epitelioma cutaneo ulcerato del dorso della mano. Arch. ital. chir., 1935, 40: 19-27.—Sweitzer, S. E. Treated squamous cell epi- thelioma of the hand. Arch. Derm. Syph., Chic, 1941, 43: 212.—Tourneux, J. P. Le cancer du dos de la main. Progr. med., Par., 1931, 149-58. ---- Cellulitis and gangrene. Aubin, R. *Panaris de la face dorsale et phlegmons du dos de la main. 47p. 8? Par., 1935. HAND 58 HAND Bani, I . Flcmmoni profondi della mano. I'mbria med., 1935. 15: 2756.—Bonoli, U. Esperimento di medicazione intrarteriosa (flcmmone profondo diffuso della mano) Poli- clinico, 1929, 36: sez. prat., 851-3- ( ercseto, P. L. Trata- miento de los flemones de la mano y antebrazo. Dia med., B. Air., 1938, 10: 64-0.— (ordier. P., & Coulouma, P. L'anatomie de la main et la chiiurgie des phlegmons de la paume; donnees nouvcllcs sur les espaces celluleux. Echo med. nord, 1934, 3. ser., 1: 513; 545; 661.- Iselin, M. Phlegmons des espaces celluleux de la main. J. chir., Par., 1932, 39: 331-65.—Krecke, A. Fortschreitende Handphlegmone nach Stricknadelverlet zung; Allgemeininfektion. In his Beitr. prakt. Chir . 1934, 109.—Lorin, H. Les panaris et les phlegmons de la main; leur examen clinique. Hopital, 1931, 19: 416-20.—Lyonnet, L. H., & Gorostiague, S. Flem6n de mano. Rev. As. med. argent., 1935, 49: 680-5.—M., L. K. Hohlhandphlegmone durch abgebrnchene Nadelspitze. Zschr. arztl. Fortbild., 1939, 36: 88.- Markuth, E. Ein Beitrag zur Funktionswiederherstellung bei \--l'li!egmoii<' der Hand. Arch. klin. Chir., 1936, 185: 370-2.- Marner, O. |Treatment of panaritium and phlegmons of the hand] Nord. mod., 1939, 4: 3308-14—Metivet, G. Un cas de l\ mphangite avec gangrene de la main. Mem. Acad. chir., Par., 1936, 62: 1130-2.—Noble, T. B., jr. Rationaliza- tion of treatment of cellulitis of the hand. J. indiana M. Ass., 1932, 25: 12-6.—Ory. Les incisions lateralisees dans les phlegmons de la main. Ann. Soc. med. chir. Liepe, 1933, 66: 30-5. Also Liege med., 1933, 26: 404-11.—Petel, H. Sur revolution et le traitement des phlegmons de la main. Progr. med . Bar., 1932, 1873-81—Poenaru-Caplescu, C, & Tovaru, S. | New technique in surgical treatment of phlegmone of the hands, caused by injuries] Spitalul, 1929, 49: 80-93— Taylor, M. M. Soft tissues of the hand in infection; a microscopical study of the pathological changes produced by deep cellulitis complicated by osteomyelitis. Indtist. M., 1936, 5: 187-92.— Trivellini, A. Infezioni flemmonose delle mani da germi anaerobi. Arch. ital. chir., 1938, 54: 756-63.—Un cas dc gangrene de la main a point de depart uterin. Clinique, Par., 1936, 31: 261. ---- Chondroma. See also Chondrodysplasia. Lepetit, R. *A propos d'un cas de chon- dromes multiples de la main. 29p. 25cm. Lyon, 1937. Alquier, A. Enchondromes multiples des 2 mains. 3'. radiol. electr., 1929, 13: 619.—Buzzi, A. Condromas multiples de la mano. Rev. cir., B. Air., 1927, 6: No. 12, 625-8.—Camentron. Enchondromes des os de la main avec malformation congenitale du coudechez un jeunesoldat. J. radiol. electr., 1928, 12: 183— Carson, H. W. Enchondromata of the hands and of the radius and ulna. Tr. M. Soc. London, 1925-26, 49: 41-3.—Forteza. Condroma multiple de los dedos v del segundo metacarpiano. Progr. chn., Madr., 1920, 15: 290— Frankenthal, L. Die praktische Bedeutung der solitaren Chondrome an den Meta- carpalknochen und Phalangen der Finger und ihre zweck- massigste Behandlung. Arch. klin. Chir., 1935, 182: 583-9.— Hammann, W. Beitrag zur Kenntnis der Hohlhandtumoren unter Beriicksichtigung eines Falles von Fibrochondrom der Hohlhand. Beitr. klin. Chir., 1929, 146: 519-25.—Ieda, S. Palliative operation of the multiple chondroma of the meta- carpi. Jap. J. M. Sc, 1934-36, 4: Surg. &c, 322.—Jimeno Vidal, F. Condromas de mano. Rev. med. Barcelona, 1931, 15: 34-47.—Linden, O. Case of chondromatosis of a meta- carpo-phalangeal joint. Acta chir. scand., 1934, 75: 181-4, pl.—Money, R. A. A case of inclusion chondroma of a meta- carpal bone following trauma. Med. J. Australia, 1937, 1: 791.—Monro, J. K. Large enchondromata in a case of dys- chondroplasia. Lancet, Lond., 1935, 1: 858-60.—Negru, D., & Graur, E. S. [Case of multiple enchondroma of the hand] Cluj. med., 1929, 10: 201.—Nelson, L. S. A case of multiple enchondromata of the small bones of the hands treated con- servatively for 15 years. Bull. Hosp. Joint Dis., N. Y., 1941, 2: 72-6.—Prouzet, J. Enchondromes de la main. Bull. Soc' radiol. med. France, 1936, 24: 383.—Rae, L. J. Dyschondro- plasia with multiple chondromata. Proc. R. Soc. M., Lond 1935-36, 29: 1655-9.—Ritter, S. A. Case of enchondroma of phalanx simulating giant cell sarcoma. Am. J. Surg., 1939, 45: 581-3.—Robbins, C. M. Multiple chondromata of hand. Surg. Clin. N. America, 1926, 6: 1473-5.—Sorkin, A. Z. [Chondromatosis of the band articulation] Ortop. travmat 1931, 5: 125-30, 3 pl. ---- Contracture, See also subheadings Fasciae; Muscles. Haessig, A. *Ein eigenartiger Fall angeblich traumatischer Kontrakturen [Basel] 23p. 8? Laupen b. Bern, 1932. Arnulf, G.. & Van der Linden. Contracture localisee de la main et de 1 avant-bras bee & un tetanos torpide; guerison par serotherapie. Lev. chir., Par., 1934, 72: 491-4.—Bunnell, S. Contractures of the hand from infections and injuries J Bone Surg. 1932, 14: 27-46.—Chavigny, P. Contractures et mams figees. Pans med., 1918, 29: 157.—Cornejo Saravia, E Contracture pitifttica y refleja de la mimo. K01 Soc cir B Aires. 1937, 21: 721.—Delrez, L. Main figee post-traumatique! Liege med., 1931, 24: 765-74.- r.aev, E. L. A splint to pre- vent contracture in surgery 'of the band. J. Am. M. Ass., 1930, 94:1063. Also repr.— (iries, L. Low voltage currents in con- tractures of the hand. Arch. Phys. Ther., 1930, 11: 10-3.— Jones, R., jr. The management of old contractures of the hand resulting from third degree1 burns. Surgery, 1940, 7: 264-75.—Kalalova Di Lottiova, V. [Material for the past 12 years on plastic operations for contractures of the hand] Bratisl. lek. listy, 1936, 16: 162-74.- Klar, S. On the diag- nostic and therapeutic employment of novocain injections in traumatic reflexive contractures. Acta orthop. scand., 1931-32, 2: 273-88.—Koch, S. L. Prevention of contractures following infections of the hand. J. Am. M. Ass., 1927, 88: 1214-7. ------• Acquired contractures of the hand. Am. J. Surg., 1930, n. ser., 9: 413-23. Also repr. ------ Contractures of the hand. Surg. Gyn. Obst., 1931, 52: 367-70.------Com- plicated contractures of the hand; their treatment by freeing fibrosed tendons and replacing destroyed tendons with grafts. Tr. Am. Surg. Ass., 1933, 51: 66-100.—Landivar, A. F., & Leoni-Iparraguirre, O. A. Garra histero-traumatica. Arch. urug. med., 1937, 10: 501-8.—Lange, M. Behandlung von Finger- und Handversteifungen ohne und mit Muskellahmung. Munch, med. Wschr., 1934, 81: 894-7.—Napalkov, N. I. [Palmar contractures of the fingers caused by dorsal scars] Ortop. travmat., 1935, 9: 43-7.—Pogorelsky, M. A. [Treat- ment of contracture of the radio-carpal joint with plaster of Paris casts applied by stages] Ibid., 1937, 11: 95-7.—Rey, J. Die orthopiidische Behandlung der Hand- und Fingerkontrak- turen. Zschr. orthop. Chir., 1927, 48: 21-31.—Rocher, H. L., & Pouyanne, L. Cicatrice vicieuse de la paume de la main; greffe libre de peau totale; resultat apres 1 mois. Bordeaux chir., 1936, 7: 184-0.—Spisic, B. Watte als orthopadisches Redressionsmittel; erfolgreiche Behandlung schwerer Kontrak- turen der Hand- und Fingergelenke. Zschr. orthop. Chir., 1932, 57: 195.—Steindler, A. The mechanics of muscular contractures in wrist and fingers. J. Bone Surg., 1932, 14: 1-16.—Walker, G. R. A discussion of the contractures de- scribed by Volkmann and Dupuvtren. Univ. Toronto M. J., 1939-40, 17: 290-4.—Zeno, L. Mano en garra; pldstica de Morestin combinada con inierto libre de piel total. Acci6n med., B. Air., 1940, 10: 545-7. ---- Cyst. Behrens, A. *Ueber traumatische Epithel- cysten [Gottingen] p. 145-51. 8? Berl., 1930. Also Virchows Arch., 1931, 280: Korp, K. *Epithelzysten entstanden nach Humanolinjektionen bei Dupuytren'scher Finger- kontraktur (ein Beitrag zur Aetiologie der Epithelzysten) 26p. 8? Erlangen, 1930. Beul, A. P. [Traumatic epidermal cysts of palms and fingers] Mosk. med. J., 1927, 7: No. 3, 35-40.—Jauregui, P. Quistes dcrmoideos de la palma de la mano. Bol. Soc. cirug. B. Aires, 1929, 13: 233-9.—King, E. S. J. Post-traumatic epidermoid cysts of hands and fingers. Brit. J. Surg., 1933, 21: 29-43.— Machan, B. J. [Traumatic epidermal cyst of the hand and fingers] Vest, khir., 1928, 13: No. 37-38, 158-77.—Metivet, G. Un nouveau cas de kystes traumatiques de la main. Sem. hop. Paris, 1926, 3: 373. ---- Deformity. Billich, H. U. Die Tischlerhand. Mitt. Grenzgeb. Med. Chir., 1926-28, 40: 638-47.—Browne, W. E. Curing the crippled hand. Bull. U. S. Dep. Lab. Div. Lab. Standards 1935, No. 2, 166-70.—Calchi Novati, G., & Cossali, C. Di una caratteristica alterazione della dita delle mani nei mungitori. Radiol, med., Milano, 1935, 22: 27-38.—Cohn, I. The crippled hand. Internat. Clin., 1934, 44. ser., 2: 225-35.—Gianturco, G. Contributo alia cura di alcune deformity cicatriziali della mano. Chir. org. movim., 1929, 13: 158-67.—Hanns, Chaumerliac, J., & Walter, E. V. Un cas de deformation de la main dite en coup de vent. Strasbourg med., 1928, 88: pt 2, 392.—Hinrichs- meyer, C. Schnellende Hand. Zbl. Chir., 1931, 58: 834-7 — Jackson, C, & Babcock, W. W. Hyperextension of hand and hngers from a burn; correction by a single pedicled skin and facial flap from anterior abdominal wall. Surg Clin N America, 1930, 10: 1285.—Lencioni, J. La mano deforme en el manejo del revolver. Rev. med. Rosario, 1933, 23: 470-88 — Massie, G. Deformities of the hand. Guy's Hosp. Gaz., Lond., 1931, 45: 296-8.—Steindler, A. The pill roller hand deformities due to imbalance of the intrinsic muscles; relief by ulnar resection. J. Bone Surg., 1928, 10: 550-3.—Von Wedel, qq a deformed hand. J. Oklahoma M. Ass., 1929, 22: », A ~,----- The crippled hand. Ibid., 1933, 26: 320-3. Also Southwest J. M. & S., 1934, 18: 77-80. ---- Deformity: Manus valga [Madelung] Arnaoudoff, K. *Contribution a l'etude de la maladie de Madelung et de son pronostic fonctionnel. 64p. 25cm. Montpel., 1934. Dejardin, M. L. *Contribution a l'etude de la maladie de Madelung. 135p. 251/2cm. Nancy, 1934. HAND 59 HAND Kun, E. Contribution a l'6tude de la maladie de Madelung. 46p. 8? Par., 1933. Nill, C. *Zur Kasuistik der sogenannten Madelung'schen Deformitat [Munchen] 21p. 8? Augsb., 1914. Peters, F. *Die Madelung'sche Handgelenks- deformitat und ihre Beziehung zur Osteodysplasia exostotica. 32p. 22^cm. Bonn, 1936. Tollas, H. *Zur Aetiologie der Madelung- schen Knochenerkrankung an der Hand eines selbst beobachteten Fades [Berlin] 35p. 8? Stuttg., 1929. Also Arch. Kinderh., 1927, 82: 112-4. Barsoum, S. Madelung's deformity. Lancet, Lond., 1935, 2: 428.—Beder, W. L., & Heinismann, J. I. Zur Genese der Madelungschen Deformitat. Fortsch. Roentgenstrahl., 1935, 52: 595-601.—Bert, J. M. La maladie de Madelung. Arch. Soc. sc. med. biol. Montpellier, 1939, 20: 358.—Bertolotti. O. La malattia di Madelung o cubitolistesi posteriore (contributo clinico) Med. prat., Nap., 1928, 13: 95-9— Bjorkroth, T. An extraordinary case of deformity of the wrist (symptomatic form of Madelung's deformity) Acta orthop. scand., 1931-32, 2: 242-52.—Brinsmade, W. B. Madelung's deformity of the hands. Ann. Surg., 1908, 47: 794, 2 pl.—Brown, G. M. Report of a case of Madelung's deformities. Med. Clin. N. America, 1922-23, 6: 1313-8.—Bsteh, O. Radiusfraktur bei Madelung'- scher Deformitat. Zbl. Chir., 1931, 58: 1955-7.—Burrows, H. J. An operation for the correction of Madelung's deformity and similar conditions. Proc. R. Soc. M., Lond., 1936-37, 30: 565-72.-—Catterina, A. Contributo alio studio della malattia di Madelung. Chir. org. movim., 1925-26, 10: 517-32 — Claiborne, E. M., & Kautz, F. G. Madelung's deformity of the wrist, with report of a case. Radiology, 1936, 27: 594—9.— Dannenberg, M., Anton, J. I., & Spiegel, M. B. Madelung's deformity; consideration of its roentgenological diagnostic criteria. Am. J. Roentg., 1939, 42: 671-6.—Dimitriu, V. Un cas rare de maladie de Madelung. J. radiol. electr., 1934, 18: 535.—Fazio, L. Sulla radiodistrofia del Madelung. Arch. ortop., Milano, 1930, 46: 551-65.—Felix, W. Beitrag zur Kasuistik der Madelungschen Deformitat. Zschr. orthop. Chir., 1927-28, 49: 563-8.—Fick, R., & Pahl, J. Ueber einen Fall von doppelseitiger Madelungscher Fehlform des Handge- lenks mit Berucksichtigung seiner Mechanik. Arch. klin. Chir., 1930-31, 163: 499-518.—Foschini, D. Contributo alia patogenesi della deformity di Madelung. Gior. clin. med., 1927, 8: 510-3.—Franke. Zur Anatomie der Madelungschen Deformitat der Hand. Deut. Zschr. Chir., 1908, 92: 156-80, pl.—Gazzotti, L. G. Contributo al trattamento della de- formity di Madelung. Chir. org. movim., 1931-32, 16: 263-73.—Gickler, H. Wachstumsstorung der Radiusepiphyse und Madelungsche Deformitat. Arch, orthop. UnfaUchir., 1933, 33: 312-8.—Goot, van den. Een geval van Made- lungsche difformiteit van de hand. Med. rev., Haarlem, 1906, 6: 289-95, 2 pl.—Gubern Salisachs, L. Contribuci6n al estudio de la deformidad de Madelung. Rev. med. Barce- lona, 1933, 20: 105-37.—Josa, L. [Cases of Madelung's de- formity of the wrists] Orv. hetil., 1926, 70: 1321-4.—Kajon, C. Madelung'sche Deformitat kombiniert mit Halsrippen. Wien. med. Wschr., 1934, 84: 460-2.—Levyn, L. Madelung's de- formity. Radiology, 1924, 3: 145-9.—MacLennan, A. Re- port of a case of Madelung's deformity. Brit. M. J., 1909, 2: 759.—Marti, T. De la maladie de Madelung-Dupuytren. Rev. m6d. Suisse rom., 1940, 60: 31-50.—Massabuau, Soula & Nichet, M. La maladie de Madelung. Arch. Soc sc. med. biol. Montpellier, 1934, 15: 191-5.—Moreau, M. H., & Romano, R. Deformidad de Madelung. Sem. med., B. Air., 1940, 47: 689-93.—Palrnieri, G. G. A proposito della dismorfosi di Madelung; le discondroplasie radio-cubitali minime. Arch. ital. chir., 1938, 53: 392-427.------ Ulteriori contributi all'interpretazione patogenetica della dismorfosi di Madelung; a proposito di un caso di deformita radio-ulnare di tipo opposto al Madelung con discondroplasia generale. Bull. sc. med., Bologna, 1939, 111: 157-65.—Pels-Leusden. Ueber die Madelungsche Deformitat der Hand. Deut. med. Wschr. 1907, 33: 372-4.—Petridis, P. A. Un cas de main bote en valgus congenital des 2 cotes chez un nouveau-n6 debile: absence bilaterale du pouce; absence du radius du cote gauche. Lyon med., 1926, 137: 756-7. Also Rev. orthop., Par., 1927, 3. ser., 14: 419-21.—Piaggio-BIanco, R. A., & Garcia-Capurro, F. Modificaciones del codo en la deformaci6n de Madelung. Arch. urug. med., 1939, 14: 532-40.—Poulsen, K. Ueber die Madelung'sche Deformitat der Hand. Arch. klin. Chir., 1904, 75: 506-32.—Prieto, E. Enfermedad de Madelung, modificaciones a la tecnica operatoria. Bol. Soc. cir. Chile, 1934, 12: 208-14, 4 pl.—Racanskf.F. [Madelung's deformity] Cas. lek. desk., 1927, 66: 1190-7.—Rocher, H. L. Maladie de Madelung: dyschondroplasie radio-cubitale inferieure par hemiatrophie epiphysaire radiale interne. J. med. Bordeaux, 1937, 114: 513-8. ------ & Canton. La veritable physio- nomie anatomo-radiographique de la maladie de Madelung. Proc. verb. Congr. fr. chir., 1935, 44: 276-84. —----Patho- genie de la difformite de Madelung. J. med. Bordeaux, 1935, 112: 676-8.—Rocher, H. L., & Rocher, C. Une nouvelle observation de maladie de Madelung. Ibid., 1940, 117: 225-8.—Rocher, H. L., & Roudil, G. Dysmorphoee congenital bilaterale des poignets par hemiatrophie epiphysaire radiale. Presse med., 1930, 38: 1089.— Roederer, C. Un cas de maladie de Madelung larvee. Bull. Soc. chir. Paris, 1928, 20: 235-7 — Roth, P. B. Madelung's deformity; after operation. Proc. R. Soc M., Lond., 1927-28, 21: Sect. Orthop., 45.—Roudil, G., Drevon & Mourgues. Dysmorphose congenitale bilaterale des poignets (maladie de Madelung) J. radiol. electr., 1936, 20: 241-5.—Schnek, F. Die operative Besserung der echten und der sogenannten symptomatischen Madelungschen De- formitat. Zschr. orthop. Chir., 1928, 50: 320-9.------ Federnde Dorsalluxation der Elle; Konsolenradius-Made- lungsche Deformitat. Ibid., 1930, 53: 101-10.—Solberg, M. To tilfadde af Madelungs haand deformitet. Tskr. Norsk. laegeforen., 1906, 36: 195.— Tancredi, G. Sulla deformity di Madelung (contributo alia cura chirurgica) Bull. Accad. med. Roma, 1931, 57: 153-8.—Tavernier. Poignet ballant par perte de substance de l'extremite inferieure du radius: greffe osseuse. Lyon chir., 1926, 23: 417-20.—Vianna, B. Doenca de Madelung. Fol. med., Rio, 1931, 12: 241-51.—Wright. L. T., & Kaufman, J. Unusual type of Madelung-like de- formity; case presentation. Am. J. Surg., 1936, 34: 365-8. ---- Disease. See also subheadings Infection; Injury, &c. Brunnschweiler, H. Un cas de troubles physiopathiques. Schweiz. Arch. Neur. Psychiat., 1939, 44: 161-3.—Cummins, R. C. Dead hand; a lesion produced by rapid vibration. Irish J. M. Sc, 1940, ser. 6, No. 172, 171-5, pl.— Kroner, K. Ein neuer Quengel- und Uebungsapparat zur Behandlung von Bewegungseinschrankungen der Finger und des Handgelenkes. Chirurg, 1934, 6: 780-2.—Laignel-Lavastine. Mains patho- Iogiques dans l'art. Aesculape, Par., 1934, 24: 66-72.— Lake, N. C. Hand, diseases and deformities. In Brit. Encycl. M. Pract. (Rolleston, H.) Lond., 1937, 6: 171-98.—Leslie- Roberts, H. The removal of the inferior cervical ganglia, and its effect of hvperidrosis and cyanosis of the hands and feet. Brit. J. Derm. Syph., 1934, 46: 126-34.—Levy, G. Concretions calcaires des mains. Bull. Soc. fr. derm, syph., 1926, 32: 589-92.—Mason, M. L. Minor surgical conditions of the hand. Surg. Clin. N. America, 1941, 21: 181-95.—Wischnowitzer, E. [Significance of careful examination of the hands of the patient in the diagnosis of internal diseases] Polska gaz. lek., 1938, 17: 657. ---- Disease, cutaneous. Ayres, S., jr. A case for diagnosis (bacterid of hands?) Arch. Derm. Syph., Chic, 1937, 36: 1308.—Beutl, P. Ueber die Bedeutung der Plaut-Vincentschen Flora bei einer ulzerosen interdigitalen Kondylomatose. Derm. Wschr., 1923, 76: 282-4.—Broster, L. R. Ulcer of hand for diagnosis. Proc. R. Soc. M., Lond., 1926-27, 20: Sect. Clin., 24-6—Crehange, J. L., & Weille, R. Localisation au niveau des mains de la dermatite d'Oppenheim chez l'enfant. Bull. Soc. fr. derm. syph., 1938, 45: 556.—Feil, A. Les stigmates professionnels et la main des travailleurs. Presse med., 1933, 41: 1783.— Gomez Orbaneja, J. Estigmas profesionales de los jugadores de pelota. Actas derm, sif., Granada, 1939-40, 31: 491.— Gonzalez Duarte. Ulcera simetrica de la mano incurable y estellectomia. Arch, med., Madr., 1935, 38: 284; 624.— Gordon, H. Granuloma of the hand. Proc R. Soc. M., Lond., 1934-35, 28: 1173.—Gougerot, Burnier [et al.] Ery- theme pellagroide bulleux hmite aux 2 mains. Bull. Soc. fr. derm, syph., 1934, 41: 1517-9.—Holzknecht. Kurze Demon- stration iiber Radikalbehandlung der Rontgenhande. Fortsch. Rontgenstrahl., 1925, 33. Kongr., 92.—Hueper, W. C. Eti- ologic studies on the formation of skin blisters in viscose workers. J. Indust. Hyg., 1936, 18: 432-47.—Krecke, A. Chronisches entziindliches Hautgeschwiir an der Hand; Verdacht auf Karzinom. In his Beitr. prakt. Chir., 1934, 579.—Lane, C. G. Dermatoses affecting the hands; comments on the differential diagnosis. Med. J. & Rec, 1928, 127: 316-8. ------ Skin disease on the hands. J. Michigan M. Soc, 1940, 39: 549-56.—Lanyar, F. Ueber eine im Gastge- werbe beobachtete Warmeschadigung der Hande. Miinch. med. Wschr., 1930, 77: 1320.—Lashinsky. I. M. A case for diagnosis (ulcerations of the right hand) Arch. Derm. Syph., Chic, 1935, 31: 763.—McLaughlin, A. I. G., & Edington, J. W. Infective warts in workers using bone-glue. Lancet, Lond., 1937, 2: 685.—Munk, F. Ueber das Wesen der Heberdenschen Knoten. Med. Klin., Berl., 1939, 35: 207.—Nicolas, J., Nov6-Josserand & Pelouraud. Nodosites cutanees dermo- fibromateuses des articulations phalango-phalanginiennes; casus pro diagnosi. Bull. Soc. fr. derm, syph., 1933, 40: 337.— Nippert, P. H. Vesicular eruptions of the hands; cases. J. M. Ass. Georgia, 1938, 27: 313-7.—Peyri, J. Las dermitis arti- ficiales de las manos. Rev. espaii. med. cir., 1933, 16: 331-4.— Pierini, L. E., & Pierini, E. A. Granuloma anular. Sem. med., B. Air., 1930, 37: 47-53.—Ristic, V. Milzbrand der Haut mit multipler Pustelbildung. Munch, med. Wschr., 1933, 80: 2018.—Rozhansky, V. T. [Allergic reaction of the skin of the hands of workers to certain species of microorganisms, taken from their hands] Khirurgia, Moskva, 1939, No. 11, 68-74 — Sellei. J. Teilweise Nagelabhebungen bei Erythrozyanose der Hande. Derm. Wschr., 1934, 99: 1261-4— Seyler. L. E. The role of allergv in vesicular eruptions of the hands. Ohio M. J., 1937, 33: 884-6.—Slater. B. J., & Barber, R. F. Sym- HAND 60 HAND posium: industrial diseases and accidents to the hand; derma- toses of the hands. N. York State J. M., 1936, 36: 1731-40 — Tommasi, L. ( heirodistrofie da lavoro minuto e ostmato; acrodcrmatiti croniche conseguenziali. Riforma med., 1929, 45: 1203.- -Van De Erve. J. M. Vesicular eruptions of bands J. S, Carolina M. Ass., 1930, 32: 163-5.—Wigley, J. E. M. Eruption on palms: case for diagnosis. Proc. R. Soc. M., Lond., 1935-36, 29: 246- Wise, F., & Wolf, J. Problems in diagnosis and treatment of recurring vesicular eruptions of the hands. N. York State J. M., 1940, 40: 1573-8. ---- Disinfection. Sec also Disinfection; Surgery. Geuther, H. *Ueber Handedesinfektion besonders vor zahnarztlichen Eingriffen [Heidel- berg] 20p. 8? Neufechingen-Brebach, 1929. Kurze, I. *Ueber Desinfektion mit Chlor und Jod und Handedesinfektion [Leipzig] 12p. 8? Zeulenroda, 1934. Leja, G. *Ueber die Brauchbarkeit der alko- holischon Carvaseptlosung zur Handedesinfektion [Breslau] 30p. 8? Ohlau, 1933. Markiewitz, R. *Ueber die Handedesinfek- tion mit der Carvasept-Seifenlosung [Breslau] 29p. 8? Liebau, 1932. Motzung, F. *Ueber die Moglichkeiten der Handedesinfektion bei unseren zahnarztlichen Arbeiten [Wurzburg] 24p. 8? Bottrop, 1933. Sickel, K. *Ueber Handedesinfektion mit physiologischem Chlorwasser und fiber die Selbst- reinigung der Hande [Leipzig] 12p. 8? Zeulenroda [1934-35] Steinacker, W. *Versuche iiber die Trocken- desinfektion der Hande. 18p. 8? Munster, 1933. Also Deut. Mschr. Zahnh., 1933, 51: 547-55. Wagner, R. *Ein Beitrag zur Handedesinfek- tion. 23p. 8? Munch., 1927. Abrahmson, B. P., & Smorodinzev, A. A. Experimentelle Untersuchungen zur Frage der mechanischen Handedesinfek- tion. Zbl. Chir., 1928, 55: 2125-30.—Ahlfeld, F. Der prak- tische Arzt und die Hiindegefahr. Samml. klin. Vortr., 1908, n. F., No. 492-3 (Gyn., No. 179)— Andreev, F. F., & Bubnov, N. M. [Preparation of the hands for surgical opera- tions according to Prof. Napalkov's method] Khirurgia, Moskva, 1939, No. 9, 51-3.—Bakkal, S. A. [Sterilization of hands with malachite green and brilliant green] Vest, khir., 1931, 23: No. 68-69, 24-32. ------ (Sterilization of the hands with Bakkalin] Ibid., 1939, 57: 518-21.—Barber, W. H., & Noble, W. C. Observation on hand sterilization. Proc. Soc. Exp. Biol., N. Y., 1925-26, 23: 339—Baumann, J. Ueber Desinfektionskurzverfahren der Hande. Med. Welt, 1939, 13: 151-3.—Blumcnberg. Ueber Dijozolseife als Handedesin- fektionsmittel. Munch, med. Wschr., 1928, 75: 694.—Bog- danov-Berezovsky, V. V., & Shukhtina, T. M. [Laboratory verification of Spasokukotsky-Kochergin method of disinfection of the hands] Vest, khir., 1940, 59: 3-9.—Breitkopf, E. Die bakteriologische Untersuchung der Tageshand. Beitr. klin. Chir.. 1926, 136: 379-84.— Bujwid, O. [Simple method oi disinfecting the hands and certain instruments] Now. lek., Poznari, 1914, 26: 338-40.—Dobkowsky, T. Die zahnarztliche Handedesinfektion. Zschr. Stomat., 1930, 28: 518-36.— Dotzer, W. Neue Wege zu einer rationellen Handedesinfektion. Arch. Hyg., Miinch., 1939-40, 123: 239-46.—Fossati, G. Contributo alio studio della disinfezione e della protezione della mano. Ann. ostet., 1913, 1: 1-33, 7 pl—Friinkel, W. K. Geschichtliche Bemerkung zu der Arbeit Lohr: Ein billiges Verfahren der Handedesinfektion. Zbl. Chir., 1934, 61: 1103.—Frank, R. Die Handdesinfektion mit Sauerstoff- Seifenschaum. Ibid., 1928, 55: 514-9. ------ A propos du lavage des mains avec H20j. Arch. med. beige, 1934, 87: 591- 8.—Fiith. Ueber Formacin, ein neues Handedesinfizienz. Verh. Deut. Ges. Gyn. (1907) 1908, 12: 663-6.—Gabai, A. V. [Pre-operative disinfection of the hands] Nov. khir. arkh., 1940, 47: 2277 — Gelinsky, E. Das Problem der Hande-, Haut- und Wund-Desinfektion in der Chirurgie vom physi- kalischen Standpunkt aus gesehen. Erg. Chir. Orthop., 1934, 27: 401-69.—Ianishevsky, F. I. [Preparing hands before per- forming operation] Vest, khir., 1927, No. 26-27, 308-12.— Jotten, K. W., & Schon, H. Zephirol zur Handedesinfektion Med. Welt, 1936, 10: 1448— Klapp, R., Vogeler, K., & Weber, W. Die fraktionierte Handesterilisierung; ein Vorschlag zur Yervollkommnung der Handedesinfektion wahrend der Opera- tion. Deut. Zschr. Chir., 1927, 200: 606-12.—Kruse & Fischer, M. Das Cumasinns>stem und die Handedesinfektion. Klin! Wschr., 1935, 14: 11*0.—Lanner, E. Vasenoloformpuder zur Erganzung der Handedesinfektion vor Operationen. Ibid 1927, 6: 670.—Liebermann, L. [Hand disinfection and tissue antisepsis] Budapesii orv. ujs., 1934, 32: 200-2.—Lilienthal, H., & Ziegler, J. M. A study in the disinfection of the hands Ann. Surg., 1926, 83: 831-0. I.indenbaum, L. M. Zur {'rage der Desinfektion der Hande in der Stomatologic. I >eut. Mschr. Zahnh., 1932,50:399-410.- I.ippay. A. Beitragzur Frank schen Handedesinfektion mit Sauerstolf-Seifenschaum. Zbl. ( lur., 1928 55: 519. ------ Zebu Jahre Erfahrung mit der Frank schen Handdesinfektion. Ibid., 1938, 65: 1387-Lohr, W. Ein billiges Verfahren der Handedesinfektion. Ibid., 1934, 61: 67-70.—Loir, A. La question de la main propre. Rev. path. comp.. Par., 1939, 39: 655-9.—Lotsch, F. Handedesinfektion ohne Hautschadigung. Med. Klin., Berl., 1937, 33: 1199- 202.—Marquis, E. Des services que peut rendre en obstetrique la desinfection des mains exclusivement par l'alcool. Bull. Soc. obst. gyn. Paris, 1912, 1: 186-8. Also Gynecologie, 1912, 16: 226. ------ Role du lavagc-savonnage et brossage dans la desinfection des mains. Gaz. hop., Par., 1912, 85: 469-74. ------Des services que peut rendre en obstetrique la desin- fection des mains exlusivement par l'alcool. Lev. prat. obst. pa;diat., Par., 1912, 25: 115-8.—Martin, A. F. Disinfection of hands for surgical procedure. Northwest M., 1927, 26: 339- 47.—Martinez Parente, S. Por que no se ha vulgarizado un procedimiento facil de esterilizar las manos del cirujano. Rev. As. med. mex., 1925, 4: 790-2.—Martov, I. [Washing of hands in a half percent ammonia solution (surgery)] Vrach. gaz., 1931, 35: 1451.—Morse, E. C. The hand scrub. Nurs. Educ. Bull., 1930, n. ser., 23.—Neufeld, F., & Schiemann, O. Ueber die Wirkung des Alkohols bei der Handedesinfektion. Zschr. Hvg., 1938-39, 121: 312-33. ------ & Kuhn, H. Unter- suchungen iiber chirurgische Handedesinfektion. Klin. Wschr., 1939, 18: 710-5.—Ozaki, Y. Ueber einige Desinfektions- methoden der Hande und des Operationsfeldes. Deut. Zschr. Chir., 1912, 115: 406-88.—Pellegrini, A. La disinfezione delle mani col solo alcool. Gazz. internaz. med. chir., 1912, 15: 897-900.—Perrin, M. Le lave-mains de Buyer. Rev. med. Nancy, 1939, 67: 99.—Pitzen, P. Eine wesentliche Verbesse- rung der Handedesinfektion durch die Sublamin-Vasoform- Methode. Beitr. klin. Chir., 1927, 141: 224-56.—Pokotilo, W. L. Noch einmal zur Frage iiber die 5%ige Tanninwasser- losung zur Handedesinfektion des Chirurgen. Zbl. Chir., 1926, 53: 1254-6.—Priselkov, P. V. [On the scrubbing of the hands with )/2% solution of spirits of ammonia according to Prof. Spasokukotsky's method] Kazan, med. J., 1930, 26: 78.— Provera, P. Ricerche sull'attivita antisettica di un nuovo prodotto destinato alia preparazione delle mani del chirurgo. Boll. Poliamb. Giuseppe Ronzoni, 1935, 9: 57; 345.—Rocholl, H. H. Erfahrungen mit Lavaman. Med. Welt, 1928, 2: 259 — Schmidt-Hoensdorf, F. Eine neuartige Handedesinfektion. Berl. tierarztl. Wschr., 1938, 54: 621-4.—Schottelius. Be- merkungen zur Handedesinfektion. Zschr. Medbeamte, 1913, 26: 530-2.—Shipachev, V. G. [Disinfection of the surgeon's hands] Vest, khir., 1928, 14: No. 40, 10-7.—Smoliak, L. G. [Comparative value of Fiirbringer's and Spasokukotsky's methods of scrubbing the hands before operations] Sovet. vrach. J., 1936, 1: 520.—Smorodintzev, A. A. [Comparative value of methods in disinfection of the hands] Vest, khir., 1929, 17: No. 50, 24-37. Also Arch. klin. Chir., 1928, 151: 640-5 — Spinner, J. R. Wandlungsmoglichkeiten chirurgischer Hande- desinfektion. Med. Welt, 1936, 10: 230-2.—Spiridonov, A. P. [New protective substance for cuts and abrasions of the sur- geon's hands before operating] Sovet. vrach. J., 1936, 1: 1347— Stewart, D. H. Aseptic or antiseptic hands in obstetric practice? which and why? Tr. Am. Ass. Obst. Gyn. (1911) 1912, 24: 283-7. Also Am. J. Obst., 1912, 65: 61-5.—Strass- mann, P. Ueber Handevorbereitung. Chirurg, 1934, 6: 525.— Siissbach, H. E. Beitrage zur Handedesinfektion; unsere Erfahrungen mit Vasoformpuder. Deut. Zschr. Chir., 1928-29, 213: 211-6.—Tashiro, K. Ein Wirkungsvergleich der kaufli- chen Handdesinfektanten. Bull. Nav. M. Ass., Tokyo, 1937, 26: No. 9, 2.—Vaichulis, J. A., & Arnold, L. Compound colored alcoholic solution of mercuric chloride for skin disinfection. Surg. Gyn. Obst., 1935, 61: 333-5.—Vasilchuk, V. M. [Dis- infection of the hands and the field of operation in cases when iodine is not available] Voen. san. delo, 1937, No. 8, 9-11.— Vogel, F. Ueber Quimbo, eine Waschsalbe. Wien. med. Wschr., 1928, 78: 1330.—Walter, C. W. The disinfection of hands. Pub. Health Nurs., 1936, 28: 825.—Westmeier, E. Versuche uber Borsiiure und Vasoformpuder als Handedesin- fektionsmittel. Deut. Zschr. Chir., 1933, 241: 111-20 — Wetzel, U. Handedesinfektionsversuche mit Zephirol. Arch. Hyg. Munch., 1935, 114: 1-9.—Winkelbauer, A. Hande- desinfektion. Wien. klin. Wschr., 1933, 46: 491.—Wulff, H. Zur Handevorbereitung und Handeschonung. Chirurg, 1936, ?7 83?~1°\ ,------& Koefoed, P. [Desinfection of the hands] Hospitalstidende, 1935, 78: [Dansk. kir. selsk. forh.j 28-31 — Zalewski, E. von. Handedesinfektion unter besonderer Be- rucksichtigung des Junijot. Med. Welt, 1928, 2: 406. ---- Dynamometry. Isikawa, T. Physiological standards and occupational characteristics apparent in bodily functions of the Japanese; power of grip measured by dynamometer. 14p. 26^cm. Kurasiki, liloJ. Corbet, G. G. Infected hand followed by loss of power in the extensors of fingers and thumbs. Canad. M. Ass. J..U926, 16: I IrT r' K' H- Ueber den Wert der Handkraftmessung bei £ A1**^Gutachtertatigkeit. Arch, orthop. UnfaUchir., 1932, .Ji: 207-74. ------& Rabinowitsch, W. Klinische Studien zur HAND 61 HAND Handkraftmessung mit dem Collinschen Dynamometer Ibid., 255-66.—Erp Taalman Kip, M. J. van. Ueber die wahrend des Tages auftretenden Veranderungen im Verhaltnis der Kraft bei der Hande. Psychiat. neur. Bl., Amst., 1914, 18: 486-99, ch.—Sellors, T. H. Loss of power in the hand. Post- grad. M. J., Lond., 1933, 9: 3-8.—Suzuki, K., Nakamoto, T., & Takata, R. Contribution to the study of the hanging power of hands. Bull. Nav. M. Ass., Tokyo, 1931, 20: 1. ---- Eczema. See also Eczema. Bizard, L. Traitement de l'eczema chronique des mains par les injections d'huile grise. J. med. Paris, 1928, 47: 551.— Goodman, H., & Kelly, D. E. Eczema of the hands: a diagnosis which can be retained. Am. Med., 1932, 38: 186-93. Also Internat. J. M. & S., 1932, 45: 279-85.—Grasreiner, H. Beitrag zur Aetiologie des interdigitalen Ekzema. Derm. Wschr., 1931, 92: 12.—Lutz, W. Chronisches Hand- und Fingerekzem. Schweiz. med. Wschr., 1938, 68: 387.—Milian, A. Streptococcic ecz6matiforme du medius. Rev. fr. derm. vener., 1939, 15: 106-10.—Peyri, J. Particularidades etio- logicas del eczema de localizacion inicial en las manos. Ars medica, Barcelona, 1931, 7: 137-43.—Runtova, M. [Case of eczema of the hands caused by feather stripping] Cesk. derm., 1932, 13: 129.—Schreus, H. T. Ueber Alkaliekzeme, ihre Entstehung und Verhiitung, mit besonderer Beriick- sichtigung moderner Waschmittel (Praecutan, Satina) Med. Welt, 1939, 13: 222-5.—Woringer, F. Tuberculesdes trayeurs sur eczema des mains. Bull. Soc. fr. derm, syph., 1933, 40: 1507. ---- Edema and elephantiasis. Dettmar, W. *Das traumatische Oedem des Handrfickens, seine Ursache und seine Be- handlung nach dem Stande der Literatur [Mun- ster] 35p. 21cm. Gutersloh i. Westf., 1938. Abbott, W. D. Periodic edema of hand with 7 day cycle: treatment with svmpathetic ganglionectomy. J. Am. M. Ass., 1933, 100: 1328. Also repr.—Andre-Thomas & Kudelski, C. Oedeme de la main cons6cutif k une morsure de chat. Rev. neur., Par., 1929, 36: pt 2, 60-5.—Becker, J. Traumatisches Oedem der linken Hand. Med. Welt, 1930, 4: 559.—Bettmann, E., jr. Ueber das traumatische, harte Oedem des Handriickens. Arch, orthop. UnfaUchir., 1932-33, 32: 570-5.—Castellani, A. Pseudo-elephantiasis of the hands. Proc. R. Soc. M., Lond., 1933, 26: Sect. Derm., 1557.—Fischer, A. W. Gibt es ein posttraumatisches Oedem des Handriickens? Arch, orthop. UnfaUchir., 1932-33, 32: 575-7.— Klassen, P. Ueber das chronische traumatische Handriickenodem. Mschr. UnfaOh., 1929, 36: 289-309—Shilnikov, L. A. [Trophic function of the dorsal interosseous nerve and its role in chronic edema of the hand] Sovrem. psikhonevr., 1930, 11: No. 7-8, 46-55 — Tinel, J., & Moncany, C. Oedeme du traumatique de la main consecutif k une morsure; role des troubles sympathiques, vaso-moteurs et trophiques. Rev. neur., Par., 1929, 36: 633-40.—Wertheimer. Oedeme de la main; ramisection cervicale. Lyon chir., 1926, 23: 366. ---- Embryology and growth. Broili, F. Ein Exemplar von Rhamphorhynchus mit Resten von Schwimmhaut. Sitzber. Math, naturwiss. Abt. Bayer. Akad. Wiss., 1927, 29-48, 4 pl.—Henckel, K. O. Beitrage zur Entwicklung der Primatenhand; zur Entwicklung der Makakenhand. Morph. Jahrb., 1929, 61: 43-8.— Koblick, H. Beitrage zur Entwicklung der Primatenhand; zur Ent- wicklung der Hand von Lemur catta. Ibid., 452-6.—Lorenz, G. F. Ueber Ontogenese und Phylogenese der Tupajahand. Ibid., 1927, 58: 431-9.—Naef, A. Notizen zur Morphologie und Stammesgeschichte der Wirbeltiere; die systematisch- morphologischen Vorstufen der Tetrapodenhand. Zool. Jahrb., Abt. Anat., 1926, 48: 405-56.—Vallois, H. V. La croissance de la main chez le chimpanze. C. rend. Soc. biol., 1932, 110: 915. ---- Fasciae. See also subheading Palm: Fascia. Anson, B. J., & Ashley, F. L. The midpalmar compartment, associated spaces and limiting layers. Anat. Rec, 1940, 78: 389-407, 5 pl.'—Bellone, A. Studio radiologico sulle tre logge osteoaponeurotiche della palma della mano. Arch, radiol., Nap., 1939, 15: 491-5.—Bolte, R., & Martin, C. R. Sur quelques faisceaux tenseurs des aponevroses. Ann. anat. path., Par., 1935, 12: 842-4.—Ferrarini, M. Morfogenesi dell'aponevrosi palmare. Pathologica, Genova, 1935, 27: 586. Also Arch. ital. anat., 1936-37, 37: 203-68.—Grodinsky, M., & Holyoke, E. A. The fasciae and fascial spaces of the palm. Anat. Rec, 1941, 79: 435-51.—Kalberg, W. Zur Anatomie der Palmaraponeurose. Anat. Anz., 1935-36, 81: 149-59. ---- Foreign body. Ahmad, I. A foreign body in the hand. Ind. M. Gaz., 1935, 70: 028.—Bouyala, J. Sur I'ablation des aiguilles dans la main. Gaz. med. France, 1930, 484.—Buckley, E. J. For- eign body, belated diagnosis. N. York State J. M., 1940, 40: Ioqa'T Sof GkisispMter m der Hand Rontgenpraxis, 193b, 8: 335.—Fraser, I. An unsuspected foreign body in the hand. Lancet, Lond., 1933, 2: 921. Also repr.—Henrard, E. Deux cas de fragments d'aiguille de la main non justiciables de I extraction sous 6cran. Bull. Soc. radiol. med. France, 1934, 22: 215.—Kahlstorf, A. Ein Hinweis auf die rontge- nologische Darstellbarkeit von kleinsten Glassplittern als tremdkorper. Deut. med. Wschr., 1933, 59: 1286.— Lamare, J. P. Petits corps etrangers de la main. Bull, med., Par., 1936, 50: Suppl. 1-4.—Prioleau, W. H. A traumatic removal of needle from hand under fluoroscope control. Tr South Surg. Ass., 1935, 48: 439-42. Also Ann. Surg., 1936, 103: ---- Infection. See also subheading (Cellulitis; Palm; Tendon); also Panaritium. Akey, H. M. infections of the hand [Mar- quette Univ.] 27p. 8? Milwaukee, 1932. Falkenstein, A. *Ueber sogenannte Melker- hande [Munster] 22p. 8? Lippstadt, 1933. Fifield, L. R. Infections of the hand. 192p. 12? Lond., 1926. Also 2. ed. 167p. 19cm. N. Y., 1939. Also Clin. J., Lond., 1926, 55: 349, passim. Kanavel, A. B. Infections of the hand. 6. ed. 552p. 8? Phila., 1933. Also 7. ed. 503p. 24cm. 1939. Peterson, J. R. *Hand infections: discussion of the more common infections and a review of 103 cases [Milwaukee Passavant Hosp.] 26p. 28cm. Milwaukee, 1940. Bailey, H. Infections of the hand. In Postgrad. Surg. (Maingot, R.) N. Y., 1936, 2: 3311-29.—Beck, C. Infection of hand and fingers. Am. J. Surg., 1930, n. ser., 8: 301-4.— Becker, E. Eitrige Entzundung der Melkerhande. Chirurg, 1930, 2: 708-11.—Best, R. R. An anatomical and clinical study of infections of the hand. Ann. Surg., 1929, 89: 359- 78.—Branch, J. L. Infections of the hand. J. M. Ass. Ala- bama, 1935-36, 5: 1-3.—Buchanan, J. S. Infections of the hand. Tr. R. Med. Chir. Soc. Glasgow, 1935, 29: 117-30.— Carscadden, W. G. Infections of the hand. S. Michael Hosp. M. Bull., Toronto, 1929-30, 4: 11-26.—Carter, D. M. In- fections of the hand. Internat. J. M. & S., 1935, 48: 187-9.— Chipman, W. A. Infections of the hand. Rep. Wayne Co. M. Soc, 1932-33, 3: 124-6.—Collins, H. L. Hand infections. J. Am. Osteopath. Ass., 1940-41, 40: 509-11.—Couch, J. H. Infections in hands. Univ. Toronto M. J., 1938-39, 16: 225-9.—Doerfler, H. Neueres iiber Ausbreitung und Be- handlung der Entziindungen der Hand. Fortsch. Ther., 1932, 8: 80; 116.—Dorris, J. M. Diagnosis of infections of the hand. Memphis M. J., 1940, 15: 142.—Dunlap, S. E. Hand infections. Surg. J., 1927-28, 34: 18-20.—Eckhoff, N. L. Infections of the hand. Lancet, Lond., 1933, 1:1276-81. Also Guy's Hosp. Gaz., Lond., 1934, 48: 246-53. ------ Prognosis of hand infection. Lancet, Lond., 1936, 1: 1369; 1425.—Flack, F. L. Fascial space and bursal infections of the hand. J. Oklahoma M. Ass., 1934, 27: 314-18.—Flaherty, F. Infected hand. Yearb. N. York N. England Ass. Railw. Surg., 1931, 14-9.— Fraser, J. Infections of the hands and fingers. Practitioner, Lond., 1932, 129: 18-32.—Fritzell, K. E. Infections of the hand due to human month organisms. J. Lancet, 1940, 60: 135-7.—Gambee, L. P. Serious hand infections. West. J. Surg., 1935, 43: 449-55.—Griffiths, S. J. H. Acute infections and suppurations of the hand and arm. Practitioner, Lond., 1930, 125: 721-30.—Handfleld-Jones, R. M. Infections of the hand. S. Mary's Hosp. Gaz., Lond., 1925, 31: 110; 127. Also Clin. J., Lond., 1926, 55: 253-62. Also Med. Press & Circ, Lond., 1933, 135: 124-6. Also Lancet, Lond., 1936, 2: 833-6.—Hardman, J. Pulp-space infection. Brit. M. J., 1937, 2: 156-60.—Heise, C. A. Acute infections of the hand. Surg. J., 1926-27, 33: 40-4.—Holmes, J. E. Infection of hand; case report. Memphis M. J., 1936, 11: No. 8, 15.—Infections of the hand. Med. J. Australia. 1940, 1: 903.—Kanavel, A. B. Clinic; infections in the hand. J. Iowa M. Soc, 1927, 17: 4-8. ------ & Mason, M. L. Hand infections. In Cyclop. Med. (Piersol-Bortz) Phila., 1939, 7: 1-41.—Kennon, R. The problem of the septic hand. Brit. M. J., 1934, 2: 1189- 92.—Kinsella, V. J. Infections of the hand. Med. J. Australia, 1939, 1: 856-61.—Koch, S. L. Acute rapidly spreading infec- tions following trivial injuries of the hand. Surg. Gyn. Obst., 1934, 59: 277-308, pl. ------ Infections of the hand. Ibid., 1935, 60: 879. Also Proc. Inst. M. Chicago, 1938-39, 12: 352.—LeSeur, H. H. Acute infections of the hand. Internat. J. Surg., 1920, 39: 86-8.—Lyonnet, J. H. Infecciones agudas de la mano. Dfa rned., B. Air., 1941, 13: 33; 53.—McKim, L. H. Infections of the hand. Canad. M. Ass. J., 1928, 18: 17-22.—Maguire, D. L. Infections of the hand. South. Surgeon, 1940, 9: 11-20.—Mason, A. Infections of the hand. N. Zealand M. J., 1939, 38: 304-15.—Mikan, V. R. Infections of the hand. J. Am. Osteopath. Ass., 1934, 34: 117-21.— Mitchiner, P. H. Some hints on the prophylaxis, diagnosis and treatment of deep infections of the hand. S. Thomas HAND 62 HAND Hosp. Gaz. Lond., 1935, 35: 10-3.—Mobley, H. E. Infections of the hand. J. Arkansas M. Soc, 1937-38, 34: 209. --Monser- rate. I). N. Infection of the hands and fingers. Med. Bull. Veterans Admin., 1936-37, 13: 321-6.—Ogilvie, W. H. In- fections of the hand. Guys Hosp. Gaz., Lond., 1930, 44: 314-21. Also J.'R. Army M. Corps, 1931, 56: 261-74.— Raison, C. A. Infections of the hand. Am. .1. Sum., 1929, n ser 6: 530 4.—Rogers, L. Injuries and infections of the hand. J. H. Nav. M. Serv., 1936, 22: 2-6.—Russell. E. P. Deep infections of the hand. J. Iowa M. Soc, 1936, 26: 689 711.—Scott, R. T. Infections of the hand; tenosynovitis and'fascial space abscesses. Northwest M., 1929, 28: 317-22 — Smyth, ('. M.. jr. Spirochaetal (Treponema vincenti) infec- tions of hand. Ann. Surg., 1932, 96: 118-53.—Solley, F. W. Preventive aspects of hand infections. Prev. M. N. Y.t 1931). 6- No 9 7- 12—llrsprung, C. W. Common infections of the fingers and hand. Hahneman. Month., 1926, 61: 6-18 — Weinberg, J. A. Hand infections; involvement of tendon sheaths and fascial spaces. Nebraska M. J., 1926, 11: 144-0.— Wheeler, W. I. de C. Infections of fingers and hand. Lancet, Lond., 1930, 2: 1010.—Wilkie, D. P. D. Infections of fingers and hand. Ibid., 944. ------ The septic hand. Brit. M. J., 1938, 2: 1127-30.—Wilson, G. E. Some of the common in- fections of the hand. S. Michael Hosp. M. Bull., Toronto, 1928 3: 43-9.—Wilson, G. M. Infections of the hand in fish handlers. Univ. Toronto M. J., 1939-40, 17: 123-7. ---- Infection: Treatment. Brickel, A. C. J. Surgical treatment of hand and forearm infections. 300p. 25J4cm. S. Louis, 1939. Andreon, E. Tratamiento de las infecciones agudas de los dedos y de las manos. Arch. urug. med., 1939, 14: 567-75.— Beattie, D. A. A case of severe sepsis of the hand, with some notes on the general treatment of such conditions. S. Barth. Hosp. J., Lond., 1932, 39: 147-52.—Bonnet, G. F. P. R. Les idees et techniques modernes relatives au traitement des in- fections aigues de la main. Arch. med. pharm. mil., 1932, 97: 1-23.—Bravo Garcia, R. Infecciones agudas de la mano y el antebrazo; su tratamiento. Clin, lab., Zaragoza, 1933, 23: 943-58.—Brea, M. M. Las infecciones de la mano; su diag- nCstico y tratamiento. Dia med., B. Air., 1930-31, 3: 357-60. ------Resultados obtenidos en el tratamiento de las infec- ciones de la mano. Ibid., 1933-34, 6: 413.—Browne, W. E. The necessity for use of splints at certain stages in the treat- ment of infections of the hand, with a demonstration of some of the newer types. N. England J. M., 1936, 215: 743-9.— Chase, I. C. Suggestions regarding hand infections. Texas J. M., 1931-32, 27: 31-4.—Clunie, T. Surgical emergencies, hand infections. Native M. Pract., Suva, 1933, 1: 100-12, 4 pl.—Clery, A. B. '1 he tieatinent of septic conditions of the band. Med. Press & ( nc, Lond., 1933, 136: 404-6.—Courtney, J. E. Management of acute infections- of the hand. Nebraska M. J., 1940, 25: 299-301.- Custer, C. G. Diagnosis and treat- ment of infection of the hands. Clin. J. Chiropody, 1934-35, 7: 414.—Daghie, V. [Infections of the hand and their treat- ment] Cluj. med., 1932, 13: 317-21.—Gonzalez, S. Trata- miento quirtirgico de las infecciones agudas de mano. Arch. med., Madr., 1934, 37: 1182-4.—Hanchett, M. Proper drain- age of infections of the hand. J. Iowa M. Soc, 1935, 25: 259-62.—Iason, A. H. Hand infections: office treatment. Am. J. Surg., 1937, 36: 376-83.—Jerabek, V. [Progress in treatment of purulent affections of the hands] Cas. lek. Cesk., 1935, 74: 241-4.—Knight, H. O. Applied anatomy in the treatment of infections of the hand. Texas J. M., 1928-29 24: 528-33. Also Bull. John Sealy Hosp., Galvest., 1940, 2: 40-7.—Koch, S. L. The diagnosis and treatment of acute infections of the hand. J. Indiana M. Ass., 1928, 21: 137-45. Also J. Med., Cincin., 1928-29, 9: 116-24. ------ The diag- nosis and treatment of some major infections of the hand. J. Iowa M. Soc, 1928, 18: 254-61. Also Minnesota M., 1932, 15: 1-7.------Some surgical principles in the care of infections of the hand. Ohio M J., 1938, 34: 1325-8. Also J. Indiana M. Ass., 1938, 31: 231. Also West. J. Surg., 1938, 46: 301-4. ------ Prevention and treatment of infections of the hand. J. Am. M. Ass., 1941, 116: 1365-7.—Lake, N. C. Infections of the hand and fingers; surgical procedures in general practice. Brit. M. J., 1938, 2: 715; 754; 798.—Le Seur, H. H. The management of hand infections. Am, J. Surg 1927, n. ser., 2: 38-42.—Marino, H. Tratamiento de las in- fecciones de la mano. Prensa m6d. argent., 1941, 28: 1104- 12.—Masciottra, E. L. El mercurocromo endoartenal en las infecciones de la mano. Rev. As. med. argent., 1941, 55: 271-3.—Mason, M. L. Principles of management of infections of the hand. Rocky Mountain M. J., 1940, 37: 814-24.— Mitrhiner, P. H. Some hints on the prophylaxis, diagnosis and treatment of deep infections of the hand. Med Press & Circ, Lond., 1935, 190: 33-5.—Ogilvie, J. H. Treatment ol infections of the hand. Kansas City M. J., 1941, 17: No. 5 16-20.—Oppegaard, M. O. Treatment of hand infections and injuries. Minnesota M., 1926, 9: 373-5.—Paredes, J. ln- feccdes da mao. Med. contemp., Lisb., 1928, 46: 269-74 — Popescu, S., & Buzoianu, G. [Actual surgery hi digitopalmar infections] Romania med., 1929, 7: 51.—Potter, P. C. Some observations on the diagnosis, and treatment of the more com- mon infections of the hand. Surg. Clin. N. America, 1936 16: 763-9.—Probstein, J. G. Pyogenic infections of the ter- minal phalanx with special emphasis on prophylaxis and treat- ment. J. Missouri M. Ass., 1933, 30: 149-52.------,^" ment of infections of the hand. Surg. Clin. N. America, 1940, 20: 1457-72.—Raiga, A. Traitement, par le bacteriophage de d'Herelle, des panaris et des plaies infect6es des doigts et de la main. Progr. m6d., Par., 1929, 44: 415-29.—Roeder, C. A. Virulent infections of the hand and forearm; treatment by prophylactic chemical and traumatic inflammation. J. Am. M. Ass., 1928, 90: 1371-3.—Rutherford, R. The closed vase- line treatment applied to the septic hand. Med. Press & Circ, Lond., 1934, 188: 359.—Sokolov, S. Behandlung eitnger Prozesse im Bereich von Fingern und Hand. Arch. klin. Chir., 1930, 161: 89-116.—Szappanos, M. [Treatment of acute infections of the hand] Oivosk6pzes, 1935, 25: aug. kiilonf., 71-82.—Tormey, A. The diagnosis and treatment of infections of the hand. Wisconsin M. J., 1931, 30: 176-86.— Troup, W. A. Infra-red rays in treatment of the septic hand. Brit. M. J., 1934, 2: 375.—Zaitsev, G. P. [Clinical aspect and treatment of acute, suppurative inflammatory affections of the wrists and fingers] Sovet. vrach. J., 1936, 1: 422-7. ---- Injury. See also subheadings. Iselin, M. Plaies et maladies infectieuses des mains. 217p. 8? Par., 1928. Siegwart, B. *Suvalrenten bei Hand- und Fingerverlusten; ein Beitrag zur Frage der Vereinheitlichung der Rentenansatze der Suval. 14p. 8? Basel, 1935. Allen, I. M. Phases in the investigation of results of head injury. N. Zealand M. J., 1939, 38: 324-33.—Allende, C. I. Heridas graves de la mano. Bol. Acad, argent, cir., 1941, 25: 13; 231.—Armstrong, H. G. Injuries of the hand. S. Michael Hosp. M. Bull., Toronto, 1929-30. 4: 54-73.—Aspinall, A. Wounds of the hand. Med. J. Australia, 1939, 2: 529-32.— Baumann, R. Ueber Fingerverluste; an Hand von iiber 400 Fallen der schweizerischen Unfallversicherungsanstalt in Luzern. Schweiz. med. Wschr., 1928, 58: 918; 939—Bevil- acqua, E. Le ferite alle dita delle mani negli operai. Gazz. osp., 1938, 59: 506-10.—Brea, M. M. Herida por hapiz tinta; necrosis de la base de un metacarpiano. Sem. med., B. Air., 1934, 41: pt 2, 120.—Corbet, G. G. Minor hand injuries re- sulting in death. Canad. M. Ass. J., 1929, 20: 40.—Davis, J. W. Hand injuries complicated by infection. Indust. M., 1937, 6: 309; 1940, 9: 565.------Hand injuries. South. M. & S., 1941, 103: 258.—Dial, D. E. Hand injuries due to injection of oil at high pressures. J. Am. M. Ass., 1938, 110: 1747.—Diez, S. Le lesioni traumatiche provocate delle mani e delle dita. Rass. med. lavoro indust., 1936, 7: 243-76.—Eckelberry, N. E. The relation of trauma of the hand to occupation. Am. J. Surg., 1938, 41: 51-6.—Gross, W. Ueber Kalanderverlet- zungen als typische Schadigung. Zbl. Chir., 1933, 60: 2790.— Haenel, H. Neurologische Folgen von Handverletzungen. Jahrber. Ges. Nat. Heilk., Dresd. (1932-34) 1934, 33.—Hand and finger injuries. Indust. M., 1935, 4: 496-500.—Harmer, T. W. Injuries to the hand. Am. J. Surg., 1938, 42: 638-58.— Herzog, K. Untersuchungen iiber die normale Wendebeweg- lichkeit der Hand und iiber die unfallmechzinische Beurteilung ihrer Einschrankung. Arch, orthop. UnfaUchir., 1937-38, 38: 539-55.—Imbert. Expertises des bless6s de la main et des doigts. Presse med., 1935, 43: 1435.—Jeannin. Note sur 2 observations de lesions complexes du poignet et du coude consecutives a une chute violente sur la paume de la main. Bull. Soc. nat. chir., Par., 1925, 51: 942-5.—Kanavel, A. B. Trivial industrial injuries of the hand leading to prolonged dis- ability. Surg. Gyn. Obst., 1933, 56: 558. ------ Hand infections in industrial accidents. Ibid., 1935, 60: 568-70.— Kerr, R. R. Injuries of the hand. Practitioner, Lond., 1931, 127: 134-40.—Koch, S. L. Injuries of the hand. Kansas City M. J., 1939, 15: No. 6, 11. Also Kentucky M. J., 1936, 34: 101-9.------Injuries of the hand; clinical lecture at Kansas City session. J. Am. M. Ass., 1936, 107: 1044-9.—Kovacs, H. J. Ueber einen Fall von Luftembolie nach einer Verletzung der Hand. Zbl. Chir., 1938, 65: 180-2.—Lasher, W. W. Un- usual injuries of the hand. Yearb. N. York & N. England Ass. Railw. Surg., 1940, 50: 31-4.—Lavermicocca, A. Recupero funzionale della mano. Atti Soc. lombard. sc. med. biol., 1924, 13: 440-2.—Leriche & Fontaine, R. Les sequelles atrophiques et douloureuses des traumatismes de la main et des doigts. BuU. med., Par., 1935, 49: 636.—Loeb, M. J. Severe laceration of hand with traumatic amputation of 2 fingers. J. Am. M. Ass., 1926, 86: 1345-7.—Lopez Esnaurrizar, M. Un punto interesante en la patologia de los machacamientos de las manos por accidentes de trabajo. Cir. & cirujanos, M6x., 1937, 5: 130-4.—Maclure, F. Crush-burns of the hand. J. CoU. burgeons Australasia, 1928, 1: 233-5.—Maloney, H. P. Por- celain faucet handle injuries. J. Am. M. Ass., 1934, 103: 1618.—Malpractice; failure to recognize septic condition of crushed hand. Ibid., 1937, 109: 1753.—Mayer, F. O. Hand- verletzung beim Boxen. Arch, orthop. UnfaUchir., 1932-33, 32: 245—Miller, F. M. The injured hand. Internat. J. M. & b.. 1934, 47: 18-22.—Mirizzi, P. L. Brulures 6tendues sur les 2 avant-bras et le dos de la main au 4« degr6; resection de la cicatrice r6tractUe; greffe pediculee de la cuisse. BuU. Soc. nat. chir., Par., 1929, 55: 780-5.—Neuman. Traumatismes de la main et des doigts. Bull. m6d., Par., 1935, 49:635.—Neumann, HAND 63 HAND H., Bonier, H. [et al.] Hand- und Fingerverletzungen. Mschr. Unfallh., 1936, 43: 196-203.—Novak, V. Hand accidents and their sequelae. Ars medici, Wien, 1936, 14: 297-301.—Oiler, A. Lesiones traum&ticas raras de la mufieca y de la mano. Arch, med., Madr., 1927, 26: 465-9.—Parker, W. S. Trau- matic surgical emphysema of the hand due to use of pneumatic tools. J. R. Nav. M. Serv., 1937, 23: 347.—Pfab, B. Ueber Hand- und Fingerverletzungen. Mschr. Unfallh., 1928, 35: 148-60.—Rocher, H. L. Deux cas d'ectrokeyrie par avorte- ment de la main. J. med. Bordeaux, 1939, 116: pt 2, 115-7.— Rozhansky, V. I. [Small wounds of the hands and fingers] Sovet. med., 1938, No. 13, 24-7.—Ruth. V. A. Injuries to the hand. J. Iowa M. Soc, 1930, 26: 90-2.—Rutherford, A. G. Injuries to the hand. West Virginia M. J., 1927, 23: 83-6.— Schmid, W. Ueber Handverletzung und Unfallneurose. Schweiz. med. Wschr., 1934, 64: 663.—Steenrod, E. J., Ghorm- ley, R. K., & Craig, W. McK. Injuries of the hands due to shattered porcelain handles of water faucets. Surg. Gyn. Obst., 1937, 64: 950-5.—StololT. A.. & Silten, A. M. Hand injuries. Indust. M., 1939, 8: 16-8.—Verderber. H. Ein halber Fingernagel in der Vorderkammcr nach Explosions- verletzung einer Hand. Zschr. Augenh., 1925-26, 58: 292-4.— Walker, R. H. Some observations of hand injuries and infec- tions. West Virginia M. J., 1926, 21: 456-60.—Winfleld, J. M. Anatomic diagnosis of injuries of the hand. J. Am. M. Ass., 1941, 116: 1367-70.—Wounds of the hand. Med. J. Australia, 1939, 2: 548.—Zeno, L. Heridas graves de la mano. Bol. Acad, argent, cir., 1941, 25: 129.—Yersin. Traumatismes de la main et des doigts; complications infectieuses. Rev. gin. clin. ther., 1935, 49: Suppl., 2429.—Zlotnikov, D. M. [Injuries among the workers driving bolts in fire arm industries; preven- tion by means of experimental research and artificially produced fractures of the phalanges] Vest, khir., 1936, 44: 271-5. ---- Injury gunshot. Arce, J., Ivanissevich, O.. & Nino, F. L. Tumor inflamatorio del dedo fndice subsiguiente a una herida de bala. Bol. Soc. cir. B. Aires, 1934, 18: 769-78.—Cardenas, M. de. Tratamiento de la mano en garra por herida de arma de fuego palmar. Rev. espan. med. cir. guerra, 1939, 3: 404-8.—Gonzalez, A. Algunos aspectos clfnicos en el tratamiento de las heridas de la mano por armas de fuego. Rev. san. mil., Habana, 1937, 1: 115-7.— Mclver, M. A. A case of gunshot wound of the hand and fore- arm. In Clin. Misc. Bassett Hosp., 1934, 1: 179-83.—Solde- villa, J. M. Tratamiento de las heridas de guerra de la mano. Rev. espan. med. cir. guerra, 1940, 4: 259-72.—Weinert. Ueber schwere Kriegsverletzungen an der Hand von im Feldc gewonnenen Bildern. Berl. klin. Wschr., 1917, 54: 692. Also Miinch. med. Wschr., 1917, 64: 879. ---- Injury: Treatment. Herisse, P. *Essai sur le traitement par la suture immediate des plaies de la main et des doigts par accidents du travail. 51p. 8? Par., 1936. Zur Verth, M. Behandlung der Finger- und Handverletzungen. 72p. 8? Lpz. [1929] Allen, H. S. Treatment of superficial injuries and burns of the hand. J. Am. M. Ass., 1941, 116: 1370-3— Allende, C. I. Heridas graves de la mano; tratamiento bio!6gico. Bol. Acad. argent, cir., 1940, 24: 714-20.—Bass, Y. M., & Zholondz, A. M. [Primary grafting of skin in fresh injuries of the hand and fingers] Sovet. khir., 1934, 6: 350-7.—Boecker, P. Eine neue volare Handschiene. Zbl. Chir., 1937, 64: 2134-7—Bohler. Traitement immediat des plaies de la main et des doigts; parties osseuses. Rev. gin. cUn. ther., 1935, 49: Suppl., 2429.— Brown, J. B. The repair of surface defects of the hand. Tr. South. Surg. Ass., 1937. 50: 366-84. Also Ann. Surg., 1938, 107: 952-71. Also Week. Bull. S. Louis M. Soc, 1937-38, 32: 326-8.—Bunnell, S. Treatment of injuries of the hand. California West. M., 1929, 30: 1-5. ------ Reconstruction of the injured hand. Rocky Mountain M. J., 1938, 35: 194-200.— Cobb, S. A. Traumatic surgery of the hand. Maine M. J„ 1935, 26: 33-6.—Desjacques, R. Broiement de la main et du poignet droits; conservation d'une pince tres utile formee par le pouce et une petite portion de l'index. Rev. orthop., Par., 1933, 20: 315-8.—Durman, D. C. Conservatism in the treatment of hand injuries. J. Michigan M. Soc, 1926, 25: 381-3.—Froste, N. [Injuries of the hand treated by phalangi- zation] Sven. lak. tidn., 1933, 30: 337-41.—Fuld, J. E. Res- toration of hand function after traumatic injury. Ann. Surg., 1934, 99: 195-216.—Gault, E. W. A case of injury to the hand illustrating some principles of plastic surgery. Melbourne Hosp. Clin. Rep., 1934, 5: 99-101.—Goldhahn, R. Versorgung von Verletzungen an Hand und Fingern. Deut. med. Wschr., 1937, 63: 1805-8.—Goiii Moreno, I. Heridas graves de la mano; tratamiento biologico. Bol. Acad, argent, cir., 1940, 24: 675-7.—Greeley, P. W. The plastic repair of cutaneous in- juries of the hand. Indust. M., 1940, 9: 300-3.—Hays, S. C. Problems in minor traumatic surgery with special reference to the hand. J. S. Carolina M. Ass., 1940, 36: 33-7.—Herlyn, K. E. Zur Lebertrangipsbehandlung von Finger- und Hand- verletzungen. Beitr. klin. Chir., 1937, 165: 278-82.—Iselin, M. Traitement des plaies de la main et des doigts. Medecine, Par., 1928, 9: 1020-8.—Kaplan, E. [Brief review of injuries of the hands and their treatment] Khirurgia, Moskva, 1938, No. 5, 93-101.—Kiser, S. [Bandaging of injured hands] Ugeskr. Ueger, 1930, 92: 347-51.—Koch, S. L. Four splints of value in the treatment of disabilities of the hand. Surg. Gyn. Obst., 1929, 48: 416-8. ------ The immediate treatment of injuries of the hand. Ibid., 1931, 52: 594-601. ------ The treatment of compound injuries of the hand. J. Lancet, 1935, 55: 570-2. —■---- Injuries of the hand; with particular reference to the immediate treatment. Nebraska M. J., 1936, 21: 281-8. ------ The treatment of compound injuries with particular reference to the hand. J. Michigan M. Soc, 1939, 38: 27-31. ------& Mason, M. L. Purposeful splinting following injuries of the hand. Surg. Gyn. Obst., 1939, 68: 1-16.—Kotilainen, T. [After-care of injuries of the hands] Duodecim, Helsin., 1940, 56: 333-5.—Lambotte, A. Contribution a la chirurgie de la main dans les traumatismes. Arch. fr. belg. chir., 1928, 31: 759-64.—Llucia, H., & Granjon, P. Du traitement conserva- teur dans les traumatismes des mains. Marseille med., 1937, 74: 32-6.—McNary, H. Anatomical considerations and technique in using occupations as exercise for orthopedic disabilities; wrist and fingers. Occup. Ther. Rehabil., 1934, 13: 24-9.—Marble, H. C. Purposeful splinting following injuries to the hand. J. Am. M. Ass., 1941, 116: 1373-5.—Martin, G. G. Value of physical therapy in the rehabilitation of common hand conditions. N. York State J. M., 1938, 38: 836-40.— Mashkara, K. I. [Primary grafting of skin in injuries of the hand] Sovet, med., 1938, No. 16, 31-3.—Mason, M. The immediate treatment of injuries to the hand. Indust. M., 1937, 6: 536-8. ------ The immediate treatment of open wounds of the hand. Mississippi Valley M. J., 1939, 61: 136-43.— Mazurova, N. A., & Mashkara, K. I. [Preliminary treatment of wounds of the fingers and wrist] Sovet. vrach. J., 1937, 41: 1810-4.—Neslon, L. S. Treatment of the commoner injuries of the hand. J. Kansas M. Soc, 1940, 41: 236-9.—Neuman. Traitement immediat des plaies de la main et des doigts. Presse med., 1935, 43: 1434. Also Rev. gin. clin. ther., 1935, 49: Suppl., 2428.—Orbach, E. Verband zur Behandlung des Streckaponeuroseabrisses am Fingerendglied. Zbl. Chir., 1935, 62: 874.—Petrowa, A. A. [Conservative treatment in accidents of crushed hands and fingers] Ortop. travmat., 1932, 6: 53-8.—Rice, E. R. Conservation of fingers in injuries and infections. Internat. J. M. & S., 1933, 46: 105-8 [Dis- cussion] 144.— Rozhansky, V. I. [Treatment of slight injuries of the hands among workmen] Khirurgia, Moskva, 1937, No. 3, 53-9.—Sarroste. Les plaies de la main: idees et techniques modernes. Arch. med. pharm. mil., 1932, 97: 24-43.—Schos- serer, W. Ueber primare Plastiken bei Hand- und Finger- verletzungen. Deut, Zschr. Chir., 1931, 233: 434-40 — Soubrane. Traitement des plaies des mains et des doigts. J. med. chir., Par., 1939, 110: 533-42.—Spencer, J. A. Treat- ment of wounds of the hand. J. Michigan M. Soc, 1938, 37: 515-21.—Travernier. Phalangisation du cinquieme meta- carpien dans une mutilation grave de la main. Lyon chir., 1928, 25: 208.—Teece, L. Treatment of wounds of the hand. Med. J. Australia, 1939, 2: 532-4.—Verebely, T. [Importance of first aid in injuries of the hand and the forearm] Orv. hetil., 1940, 74: 647-51.—Vogeler, K. Ueber die Behandlung von Finger-, Hand- und Handgelenksverletzungen. Med. Welt, 1933, 7: 1097-100.—Volkmann, J. Ueber die Versorgung von Hand- und Fingerverletzungen. Mschr. Unfallh., 1936, 43: 417-25.—Zacharinas, B. [Treatment of lacerated wounds of the hands] Medicina, Kaunas, 1930, 11: 39-41.—Zeno, L. Heridas graves de la mano; tratamiento biol6gico. Bol. Acad. argent, cir., 1940, 24: 039; 863. Also Dia med., B. Air., 1940, 12: 1138-41.------ & Allende, C. I. Heridas graves de la mano;.tratamiento biologico. Prensa med. argent., 1940, 27: pt 2, 2342.—Zholandz, A. M. [Certain methods of first surgical aid in injuries of the hand] Sovet. khir., 1932, 2: 136. ---- Joints. See also Carpus; Finger; Metacarpus; Wrist. Ghigi, C. Contributo alio studio della articolazione della mano. Chir. org. movim., 1938-39, 24: 344-72.—Hora, K. Examen des articulations de la main chez les gymnastes. C. rend. Soc biol., 1932, 111: 414-6.------ Les modifications des os et des articulations de la main chez les gymnastes femmes. Ibid., 1933, 114: 762-4—Plecnik, J. Ueber eine paradoxe typische Gelenkigkeitsasymmetrie der menschlichen Hand. Anat. Anz., 1927, 63: 87.—Schlaginhaufen, O. Ueber familiares Vorkommen der Ueberstreckbarkeit der Gelenke der Hand. Zschr. Morph. Anthrop., 1934, 34: 386-97, tab.— Vilhena, H. de. Cartas sobre anatomia; a um discipulo; das articulacoes da mao. Arq. anat., 1938, 19: 293-9. ---- Joints: Disease. See also Arthritis; Rheumatic fever; Rheuma- tism. Cordies y Negret, J. E. *Contribution a l'6tude du traitement de l'arthrite suppuree des doigts par la resection articulaire. 69p. 8°. Par., 1937. Scott, S. G. Radiological atlas of chronic rheumatic arthritis (the hand) 76p. 4? Lond., 1935. Becker, F. T. Knuckle pads. Arch. Derm. Syph., Chic, 1941, 43: 430.—Buxton, S. J. D. Common injuries to joints of HAND 64 HAND the fingers and wrist, Clin. J., Lond., 1931, 63: 270-4.— Dam, G. van. De nouveaux faits dans le radiodiagnostic des mains chronique lhumatismales. Acta rheumat., 1936, 8: H. 30, 25- 30. Also Rev. rhumat., Par., 1936, 3: 823— Ebbenhorst Tengbergen. J. van [Roentgen examination of I he hand in iclalion to rheumatic affections of the joints] Ned. tschr. geneesK., 1934, 78: 4060-6, pl- Forrester. C. R. G. Author's method for repair of ankyloaed joint of liand. Am. ,1. Surg., 1936. 33: 101-3, 7 pl.—Jonsson, E. Ueber sogeiumnte Arthro- pathia mutilans. Acta med. scand., 1938, 96: 28—12.—Koch, S. I.. Disabilities of band icsiilting from loss of joint function. ,1 Am. M. Ass., 1935, 104: 30-5.—Kuhns, J. G. The recovery of function in the hand in chronic arthritis. J. Bone Surg., 1935, 17: 939-44.—Nowotny, II. Ueber die ellenwartige Ablenkung der Finger bei chronischen Erkrankungen der Gelenke 'der Muskeln, Sohnen und Sehnenscheiden) Zschr. orthop. Chir., 1933, fid: 333 45— Ray, M. B. The arthritic hand. Pioc R. Soc. M.. Lond., 1933, 27: Sect. Phys. .Med. 193 202 - Schaffer, F. 1 ni\ < isalpendelapparat fiir Hand- und I'ingergtlenke. Deut. mod. Wschr., 1925, 51: 441.—Sundt, H. Ueber Osteochondritis phaLmguni manus; ein Beilrag zur Eiforschung der nicht spezifischen phalangealen und meta- karpophalane;ealen Gelenkleiden. Acta orthop. scand., 1936, 7: 1-85.- Terray, M. Sur 2 observations d'arthrities de la main dues a des micro-traumatismes. Rapp. Congr. internat. rhumat. (1932) 1934, 3. Congr., 134. ---- Joints: Dislocation. Waxderburg, K. *Die perilunare Dorsal- luxation der Hand (Luxation des Os lunatum) [Breslau] 35p. 22>2cm. Liebau, 1935. Kahlmeter, G. An apparatus for the treatment of devia- tions in the metacarpophalangeal- and intcrphalangeal articu- lations. Acta rheumat., Rotterdam, 1933, 5: No. 18, 5.— Michaelsson. 10. Case of luxatio manus. Acta chir. scand., 129(>, 60: 2S7- '.'■. pl- Nicolaysen, K. Luxatio manus. Ibid., 1923 2 1, 5t>: 3(15 7. Perschl, A. Luxation des Mondbeins nach volar und niclil pei ilun;.re Luxation, der Hand nach dorsal. Arch, orthop. 1 nfallchir.. 1937-38, 38: 657-61.—Rauber, A. Die perilunate Luxation der Hand; Besprechung von 44 Fallen aus dem Material dot Suval. Schweiz. med. Wschr., 1941, 71: 34; 49. Scheggi, S. Cause di irriducibilita della metacarpo- falangea driH'indice in lussazione palmare. Chir. org. movim., 1935- 30, 21: 142-8. ------ Note di tecnica per la riduzionc cruenta della lussa.doue metacarpo-falangea palmare del pollice e dell'indice. Ibid., 1936-37, 22: 2S1- 4 - Schmier, A. A., & Burman, M. S. Traumatic axial rotation by gear movement of the carpal scaphoid and trapezium with subluxation and fore- shortening of the tiist metacarpal. Am. J. Roentg., 1938, 39: 945-9.— Shorbe, H. B. Carpometacarpal dislocations. J. Bone Surg., 1938, 20: 454-7. ---- Lipoma. Auvray. Lipome de la paume de la main. Bull. Soc. nat' chir., Par., 1926, 52: 47.—Baumtartner, E. A., & Rhudy, W. P. Lipoma of the hand. Clifton M. Bull., 1928-29, 14: 95-7.— Desbonnets, G. Lipome de la main. J. sc. med. Lille, 192b, 44: pt 2, 281-5. — Guillemin & Bardin. Sur un ca« de lipome de la main. Rev. med. Nancy, 1939, 67: 18-20.—Pollosson, E., Francon, F., & Pizzera, G. Un diagnostic differentiel; lipome de la main ou svnovite avec epanchement de la grande gaine palmaire. Bruxelles med., 1937-38, 18: 879.—Scheffelaar Klots, T. [Case of lipoma of the palm] Ned. tschr. gerieesk., 1928, 72: pt 2, 4537.—Straus, F. H. Deep lipomas of the hand. Ann. Surg., 1931, 94: 269-73. ---- Movement. Kopits, I. Gelenkpeiimetrische Untersuchungen an der Hand. Arch, orthop. UnfaUchir., 1935-36, 36: 1-33. ■------ Zur pathologischen Mechanik der Hand, auf Grund eigener gelenkperimetrischer Messungen. Verh. Deut. orthop. Ges. (1934) 1935, 29: 51-4.—Montpellier, G. de. Note sur l'acceie- ration dans les mouvements volontaires de la main. Arch. psychol., Geneve, 1937, 26: 181-97.—Peugniez, P. Cinemati- que de la main; la main du prestidigatateur. Presse med., 1927, 35: 123-5.—Schreiber, H. Zur Morphologie der Primatenhand; die Extrembewegungen der Schimpansenhand. Morph. Jahrb 1936. 77: 22-60— Straus, W. L., jr. The posture of the great ape hand in locomotion, and its phvlogenetic implications Am. J. Phys. Anthrop., 1940, 27: 199-207—Uzhelevsky, A. S. [Method of examining the hand movements with new appa- ratus—cheirokinesimeter] Sovet. psikhonevr., 1932 8: 72-80 8 pl. ---- Muscles. Cabrera Caiderin, C. Algunas consideraciones acerca de la inserci6n terminal del palmar mayor. Rev. med. cubana, 1927, 38:633.- Pontes, V. Os musculos intrinsecos da mao no-Portu- gueses de condicao humilde. Arq. anat., 1932-33, 15: LS9-473. ------ Note sur le muscle manieux. Inid.. 1933-34, 16: 139- 44.—Kozlik, F. Vergleichende Unter.-ucliungeii an den i.eideu langen Fingerbeugern des Menschen. Zschr. Anat. Entw 1937, 107: 461-502—Nikolajew, P. W. Zur Frage iiber die funktionale Bedeut-amkeit der Mm. palmaris longi beim Menschen. Anat. Anz., 1932-33, 75: 145-60- Salsbury. C. R. The interosseous muscle of the hand. J. Anat., Lond 1930-37 71: 395 -403.- Stoppoloni. G. Aucora sulla porzione olrcranica del m. Ilexor digitalis profundus. Boll. Soc. eustach., 1929, 27: 67-9.— Voss. Sechs Querschnittsprapaiate einer Muskcl- spindel (vom Anfang bis zur Mitte) aus einem Lumbrical- muskel der Hand. Verh. Anat. Ges., 1939, Ifi: I 16. ---- Muscles: Contracture, ischaemic [Volk- mann] Sec also Muscle, Ischaemia. Bcue, J. *La retraction ischemique de Volkmann; a propos de 3 cas trait^s par la resection diaphysaire des 2 os de l'avant-bras. 39p. 8? Par., 1933. Akatov,"M. V. [Volkmann's contracture] Ortop. travmat., 1939, 13: No. 4, 47-56.- -Albanese, A. Contributo alia cura della paralisi iscliemica di Volkmann (retrazione muscolare) Rinasc. med., 1929, 6: 181-3, pl.—Andre-Thomas, Sorrel, E., & Sorrel-Dejerine. Quatre cas de svndrome de Volkmann. Rev. neur., Par., 1935, 42: 505 -28.—Bailey, H. Volkmann's ischaemic contracture treated by transplantation of the internal epicondyle. Brit. J. Surg., 1928-29, 16: 335-7 — Buuehman, D. S. Volkmann contracture. J. Lancet, 1935, 55: 158; 162.—Blondeau, A., Miramond de la Roquette & Ferrere. Syndrome de Volkmann, gu6ri par la diathermo- ionisation. Bull. Soc. radiol. med. France, 1935, 23: 478.— Bourguignon, G. La griffe de la maladie de Volkmann; son interpretation par la chronaxie et son traitement par la dieiec- trolyse d'iode. Ibid., 1936, 24: 295-309.—Carcassone, F.. & Frieh, P. Contribution k l'etude des indications des operations sympathiques dans le syndrome de Volkmann. Marseille med., 1934, 71: 447-70.—Carson, H. W. Volkmann's ischaemic myositis. Proc. R. Soc. M., Lond., 1927-28, 21: Sect. Clin., 70.— Ceballos, A., & Caeiro, J. A. Sobre un caso de contractura isquemica de Volkmann tratado por simpaticectomia de la aiteria humeral. Prensa m6d. argent., 1926-27, 13: 853-60.— Ceballos, A., A Gioia, T. Contractura isquemica de Volkmann, tratada por la simpaticectomia humeral. Bol. Soc. cir. B. Aires, 1927, 11: 147-53.------Resultado alejado en un caso de retracci6n isquemica de Volkmann sometido a la simpaticectomia periarterial. Ibid., 1928. 12: 185-91.------ Retracci6n muscular isquemica de Volkmann curada por la simpaticectomia de la artcria humeral. Sem. med., B. Air., 1931, 38: pt 2, 267-9.—Chassard & Ponthus. Reaction de d6generescence dans le syndrome de Volkmann. Lyon m6d., 1931, 147: 101-4.—Diamant-Berger, L. Un cas de tenoplastie des muscles fiechisseurs des doigts pour une main en griffe (pseudo-maladie de Volkmann) Bull. Soc. chir. Paris, 1935, 27: 541-5.—Ely, L. W. Volkmann's contracture. In Cyclop. Med.(Piersol-Bortz) Phila., 1939, 10: 314-8.—Esperabe & Gonzalez, J. Consideraciones sobre la pathogenia y trata- miento del sindrome de Volkmann. Med. ibera, 1931, 15: pt 2, 285-94.—Fol Masson, A. Syndrome de Volkmann typique; intervention; integrite de l'art6re hum6rale. Mem. Acad chir., Par., 1936, 62: 1166-72.—Fontaine, R., & Kunlin, J. Contribution k l'etude du syndrome de Volkmann de cause vasculaire; son traitement prophylactique ou abortif par l'intervention immediate ou precoce sur l'artere lesee. J. chir., Par., 1936, 48: 161-72— Franck, E. Gegenwartiger Stand der Lehre von der ischamischen Kontraktur nach Kondylenbruch und der Ausgang hierauf begriindeter Haftan- spruche gegen den behandelnden Arzt. Mschr. Unfallh., 1936, 43: 321-36.—Gomez Duran, M. Retracci6n isquemica de Volkmann tratada por resecci6n de muneca y alargamiento tendinoso. Rev. cir. Barcelona, 1935, 10: 231-45.—Guille- minet. A propos du syndrome de Volkmann. Lyon chir., 1937, 34: 183-7. —---- Resultats du traitement de la retraction ischemique de Volkmann. Ibid., 1939, 36: 232-5.— Hamada, G. An unusual cause of Volkmann's ischaemic contracture. Brit. M. J., 1937, 2: 418.—Hill, R. L., & Brooks, B. Volkmann's ischemic contracture in hemophilia. Ann. Surg., 1936, 103: 444-9.—Hsi-en Shih. Volkmann's contrac- ture with a report of a case. Nat. M. J., China, 1931, 17: 315-22, pl.—Inclan, A. La operacion de Henle en el trata- miento de la retracci6n isquemica de Volkmann. An cirug Habana, 1929, 1: 9-16.—Jamin, M. Paralysie de Volkmann; resection diaphysaire antibrachiale. Lyon chir., 1934, 31: 91-4.—Jeanne. Retraction ischemique des muscles thenariens (maladie de Volkmann a la main) Bull. Soc. chir. Paris 1921 47: 714-7.—Jones, S. G. Volkmann's contracture. J. Bone Surg., 1935, 17: 649-55.—Juaristi, V. El sindrome de Volk- mann y la radicectomia. Rev. cir., B. Air., 1927, 6: No. 12, 760-5.—Koch, S. L. Volkmann's contracture. Tr. West. Surg. Ass., 1934, 44: 222-35.—Lance. Maladie de Volkmann ancienne avec obliteration de lhumerale; resection tardive de 1 artere obliteree; amelioration. Bull. Soc. nat. chir., Par., 1933 59: 582-4.—Leveuf, J. Evolution d'un cas typique de syndrome de Volkmann. Mem. Acad, chir., Par., 1937, 63: 751;—Lombard, P., & Munera, G. La r6alit6 du spasme artenel dans un syndrome de Volkmann. Ibid., 1939, 65: 753-5.—Luzuy. Contractures isch6miques par plaies en seton du membre sup6rieur; leur traitement par infiltration anes- thesique du ganglion stellaire. Ibid., 1940, 66: 2-5.—Massa- buau, G. La maladie de Volkmann. Rev. gin. clin th6r 1931 45: 691-5.—Mathieu. P., Padovani, P. [et al.] Syndrome de Volkmann traite par arteriectomie; etude histologique de 1 artere humerale oblit6ree. Presse med., 1934, 42: 1819-21 — HAND Meyerding, H. W. Volkmann's ischemic contracture associ- ated with supracondylar fracture of humerus. J. Am. M. Ass., 1936, 106: 1139-44. ------& Krusen, F. H. The treatment of Volkmann's ischemic contracture. Ann. Surg., 1939, 110: 417-26.—Meyerding, H. W., & Pollock, G. A. Fracture of the capitellum with Volkmann's ischemic contracture: treatment by surgical procedures. Proc. Mayo Clin., 1938, 13: 289-94.— Michans, J. Sfndrome de Volkmann; contribucion al estudio de las intervenciones sobre el sistema simpatico. Prensa med. argent., 1937, 24: 1015-25.—Moulonguet, P., & Seneque, J. Syndrome de Volkmann: aponevrotomie precoce; guerison. Bull. Soc. nat. chir., Par., 1928, 54: 1094-7.—Mutel. La pathog6nie de la maladie de Volkmann. Rev. med. Nancy, 1936, 64: 351-8.------& Durand. Contribution a l'etude de la pathogenie de la maladie de Volkmann. Rev. orthop., Par., 1934, 3. ser., 21: 510-7.—Paitre, M. Consideration sur le traitement de certaines formes de la retraction ischemique de Volkmann; la forme palmaire. Bull, med., Par., 1932, 46: 819-23.—Perez Lorie, J. Retracci6n isquemica de Volkmann. Vida nueva, Habana, 1941, 47: 123-33.—Perrot, A. Syndrome de Volkmann traite par l'arteriectomie humerale precoce. M6m. Acad, chir., Par., 1936, 62: 517-23.—Pouzet. Resec- tion partielle du poignet pour retraction ischemique de Volk- mann. Lyon chir., 1933, 30: 581-4.—Putti, V. Considerazioni sulla deformita di Volkmann. J. internat. chir., Brux., 1938, 3: 189-218.—Rastelli, E. Contributo alio studio della sindrome di Volkmann. Minerva med., Tor., 1938, 29: 390.—Rossi, C. La retrazione ischemica di Volkmann. Chir. org. movim., 1934-35, 19: 232-8.—Scherb, R. Kann der Arzt fur die Entstehung der ischamischen Fingerkontraktur nach Ellbogen- und Unterarmbriichen beim Kinde verantwortlich gemacht werden? Schweiz. med. Wschr., 1935, 65: 579.—Seneque, J. A propos du syndrome de Volkmann. Prat. med. fr., 1936, 17: 427-35.—Sorrel, E. A propos du syndrome de Volkmann; une technique nouvelle de resection des os de l'avant-bras: l'osteotomie en chevron. Paris med., 1935, 95: 569-73.— Swietochowski, G. de. A case of Volkmann's ischaemic contracture of the hand. Lancet, Lond., 1913, 1: 1380-2.— Tavernier & Dechaume. Les lesions initiates dans la paralysie de Volkmann. Lyon chir., 1937, 34: 117-22. ------ & Pouzet, F. Infarctus musculaires et lesions nerveuses dans le syndrome de Volkmann. . J. med. Lyon, 1936, 17: 815-27. ---- Muscles: Disease and deformity. Brugi, G. Presentazione di una rara rariet& bilaterale del muscolo estensore proprio dell'indice. Atti Accad. fisiocr. Siena, 1939, 11. ser., 7: Stud. Fac. med. senese,' 282-5 — Cabrera Calderin, C. Anomalia del extensor proprio del dedo indice. Cr6n. med. quir. Habana, 1928, 54: 272-4.—Heuyer, G., Roudinesco & Lesueur. Myotonic localisee aux flediisseurs de la main. Rev. neur., Par., 1936, 65: 969-71.—Hill, T. R. Wasting of the small muscles of the hand. Med. Press & Circ, Lond., 1940, 203: 186-9.—Lhermitte, J., & de Massy, J. L'amyotrophie thebarienne non evolutive du vieillard. Rev. neur., Par., 1930, 37: 1202-7.—Mainland, D. An uncommon abnormality of the flexor digitorum sublimis muscle. J. Anat., Lond., 1927-28, 62: 86-9.—Russell, K. F., & Sunder- land, S. Abnormalities of the lumbrical muscles of the hand. Ibid., 1937-38, 72: 306.—Sa Fortes Pinheiro, L. C. de. Con- tribuicao ao estudo das variacoes musculares; accessorius ad pollicem de Gantzer. Arch. Inst. Benjamin Baptista, Rio, 1939, 5: 457-62.—Stincer, E. Adductor supernumerario del dedo mefiique. Rev. med. cir. Habana, 1939, 44: 274.— Thomsen, W. Gerate zur aktiven und passiven Gymnastik der Vorderarmmuskulatur, insbesondere der Fingerbeuger und -strecker. Arch, orthop. UnfaUchir., 1933, 33: 161-6 — Vilhena, H. de. Varias anomalias do musculo pequeno palmar. Arq. anat., 1912-13, 1: 39-43. ------ Le muscle surnumeraire extenseur comun du pouce et de 1'index. Ibid., 1933-34, 16: 147-62. ---- Mycosis. See also under various types of mycotic disease. Froes, H. P. Sobre um caso de mycose da mao, de aspecto pseudo-mycetomatoso, radicalmente curado com a medicacao iodada. Arch, brasil. med., 1931, 21: 325-8, pl.—Glasser, R., & Woringer, F. Mycose v6getante du dos de la main simulant une tuberculose verruqueuse. Bull. Soc. fr. derm, syph., 1934, 41: 1447-52.—Highman, W. J. Epidermophytosis and epidermophytids of the hands. J. Am. M. Ass., 1930, 95: 1158-62.—Hollingsworth, R. S. Unusual case of actinomycosis of the hand. Ibid., 1935, 105: 1266.—Huang, P. T. Ueber einen Fall von dyshidrosiformer, oberflachlicher Hautaktino- mykose der Handteller und Fussohlen. Derm. Wschr., 1933, 97: 1679-85.—Jadassohn, W., & Peck, S. M. Epidermophy- tide der Hande. Arch. Derm. Syph., Berl., 1929, 158: 16-27 — Klaber, R. Primary actinomycosis of the hand. Proc. R. Soc. M., Lond., 1933, 26: Sect. Derm., 36.—Lomholt, S. [Blasto- mycosis of the hands] Dansk. derm, selsk. forh., 1931-32, 64 • 52 —Mazzini, O. F. Micetoma de la mano (actinomyces meianico) Bol. Soc. cir. B. Aires, 1934, 18: 943-6.—Milian, G. Trichophytie de la main et eruptions secondaires k distance. Bull Soc. fr. derm, syph., 1936, 43: 979-84. Also Rev. fr. derm, vener., 1936, 12: 329-40.—Myers, J. T., & Dunn, A. D. Aspergillus infection of the hand. J. Am. M. Ass., 1930, 95: 794-6. Also repr.—Scholtz, M. Epidermophytids as a clinical 227475—vol. 7, 4th series----5 HAND conception. Arch. Derm. Syph., Chic, 1932, 25: 812-22.— Williams, C. M. Trichophytid of the hands. Ibid., 1933, 27: ---- Nerves. Bena, E. [Chronaxia of antagonists of the third and fourth fingers of the right hand] Rev. neur. psychiat., Praha. 1932, 29: 81.—Darrow, C. W. Neural mechanisms controlling the palmar galvanic skin reflex and palmar sweating. Arch. Neur. Psychiat., Chic, 1937, 37: 641-63.—Eidonova, M. B. [Differ- entiation of tactile sensibility of the hand] Nevropat. psikhiat., Moskva, 1937, 6: 94-109.—Karnosh, L. J.. & Williams, G. H., jr Studies of the decorticated hand. Ohio M. J., 1937, 33: 137-41.—Koch, T. Die Endausbreitung des N. volaris beim Pferde. Wien. tierarztl. Mschr., 1939, 26: 293-8.—Landra, G. Principes et methode pour l'etude de la vascularisation des nerfs dans les regions palmaires de l'avant-bras et de la main. Ann. anat. path., Par., 1938, 15: 681-3.—Laux & Cabanac. L'innervation sensitive de la face dorsale de la main. Arch. Soc. sc. med. biol. Montpellier, 1930, 11: 120-3.—Mogi, E. Untersuchung iiber die sensible Innervation der Handrucken bei den japanischen Feten; bei 12 Anenkephalen und einem Thorakopage. Okajimas fol. anat., 1937, 15: 675-84.------ Bei 100( anscheinend normalen Feten. Ibid., 1938, 16: 39; 193.—P'an, Ming-Tzu. The cutaneous nerves of the Chinese hand. Am. J. Phys. Anthrop., 1939, 25: 301-9.—Seres, M. Contribuci6 a l'estudi de la distribuci6 del nervi mitja. Tr. Soc. biol., Barcel., 1914, 2: 105-9. ---- Nerves: Disease. Andre-Thomas. Blessure partielle du median, du radial, de l'artere radiale; algies persistantes, spasme de l'artere radiale; intervention chirurgicale; guerison. Presse med., 1934, 42: 33.—Burman, M. S. The spastic hand. J. Bone Surg., 1938, 20: 133-45.—Caponhetto, A. Anomalie nei comportamento dei nervi nella regione palmare dell'uomo. Monit. zool. ital., 1930, 41: 180-3.—Harmer, T. W. Traumatic lesions of the nerves of the wrist and hand. Am. J. Surg., 1940, 47: 517-41.—Johnson, G. V. Occupational therapy for the spastic hand. Occup. Ther. Rehabil., 1937, 16: 29-32.—Lange, J. Probleme der Fingeragnosie. Zschr. ges. Neur. Psychiat., 1933, 147: 594- 610.—Lhermitte, J., & Claude, O. Troubles de la sensibilite k disposition cheiro-orale dans une lesion corticale en foyer. Rev. neur., Par., 1935, 42: 427-31.—Turner, H. Neuro- trophic disturbances of the hand associated with a bite of a cat or Colles' fracture. J. Bone Surg., 1931, 13: 161-8.— Wartenberg, R. Ueber Neuritiden im Handgebiet. Deut. Zschr. Nervenh., 1932, 124: 185.—Zur Verth, M. Periphere akute Trophoneurose der Hand. Mschr. Unfallh., 1929, 36: 309-17. ---- Ossification. Siegert, F. Atlas der normalen Ossifikation der menschlichen Hand. 43p. 4? Lpz., 1935. Todd, T. W. Atlas of skeletal maturation (Hand) 202p. 4? S. Louis, 1937. Agrifoglio, M. Ossificazioni traumatiche para-articolari della mano. Arch. ital. chir., 1934, 36: 409-21.—Cattell, P. Preliminary report on the measurement of ossification of the hand and wrist. Human Biol., 1934, 6: 454-71.—Hellman, M. Ossification of epiphysial cartilages in the hand. Am. J. Phys. Anthrop., 1927-28, 11: 223-44, 6 pl.—Howard, C. C. The physiologic progress of the bone centers of the hands of normal children between the ages of 5 and 16 inclusive; also a comparative study of both retarded and accelerated hand growth in children whose general skeletal growth is similarly affected. Internat. J. Orthodont., 1928, 14: 948; 1041.— Stettner, E. Ossificationsstudien am Handskelet; iiber Pseudo- epiphysen des Handskelets. .Zschr. Kinderh., 1931, 51: 459- 72.—Vallarino D., J. La osificacion en los huesos de las manos en nifios de diferente clase y condici6n social, de seis a ocho afios de edad, sanos y enfermos. Arch. Fac. cien. med., Quito, 1933, 3: 129-63, ch, 13 pl. ---- Palm [Vola manus] Cordier & Coulouma. Donnees nouvelles sur les espaces celluleux de la paume de la main. Rev. chir., Par., 1934, 72: 663-88.—Cummins, H. The topographic history of the volar pads (walking pads; Tastballen) in the human embryo. Contr. Embryol. Carnegie Inst., 1929, 20: 103-25, 8 pl.—Darrow, C. W., & Freeman, G. L. Palmar skin-resistance changes con- trasted with non-palmar changes, and rate of insensible weight loss. J. Exp. Psychol., 1934,17:739-48.—Espregueira Mendes, J. de. Les variations du palmaire grele chez les Portugais. C. rend. Soc. biol., 1927, 96: 886.—Freeman, G. L., & Simpson, R. M. The effect of experimentally induced muscular tension upon palmar skin resistance. J. Gen. Psychol., 1938, 18: 318- 26.—Henry, A. K. A medial approach to the mid-palmar space and ulnar bursa. Lancet, Lond., 1939,1:16-8.—Spalding, J. E. The fascial spaces of the palm; a contribution to their surgical anatomy. Guy's Hosp. Rep., Lond., 1938, 88: 432-9 — Wilder, H. H. Palm and sole studies; the morphology of the hypothenar of the hand; a study in the variation and degenera- tion of a typical pattern. Biol. Bull., 1926, 50: 393-405. HAND 66 HAND ---- Palm: Disease. Htrard. CuilUminet & Michel, L. Cicatrice palmaire retractile; traitement chirurgical et traitement orthopediquc par l'appareil a tourniquet. Lyon chir., 1927, 24: 733-5.— lirowne, W. K. Palmar abscess: lumbrical abscess: plastic procedures for relief of contractures in the forearm and hand, with demonstration of types of splints used in this work. Yale J. Biol., 193 1 35. 7: 489.—Garcia Capurro, R. Abscesos sub- cut&neos de la palma de la mano. Arch. urug. med., 1934, 4: 133-40 (Jute, J., Thiers, H., & Rachouchot, J. Syndrome svnipathique des regions pahnaires. Bull. Soc. fr. derm, syph., 19.37, 14: 730-5.—lselin & Evrard. Note sur les infections localisees aux espaces celluleux de la loge palmaire mediane (d'apres 28 observations) Bull. Soc. nat. chir.. Par., 1931 57: 1020-2. — koch, S. I.. Infections of the fingers and palm Pennsylvania M. .1., 1939 37, 40: 597-004. — Pemberton, P. A. Infection of fascial spaces of the palm. Am. ,1. Surg., 1940. 50: 512-5.— Schultze. W. Talg- und Schweissdrusenatrophie der Hohlhiinde. Derm. Wschr., 1939, 108: 79. Sembon, S. Ueber Dermatitis exsiccans palmaris. Taiwan igakkai zasshi. 1931, 30: 70.- Touraine, A. Les affections dermatologiques de la paume des mains. Presse med., 1937, 45: 1517. --- — & Payet. M. Phlyctenose recidivante des paumes, a propos des bacteridcs d'Andrews. Bull. Soc. fr. derm, syph., 1938, 45: 1020-2.- Vilhena, H. de. Aponevrose palmar media anoi inal- mente espessada e de uniao a mais intima e forte com o liga- mento transverso do metacarpo e as Bainhas fibrosas dos tend5es flexores ao nfvel do -4° e 5? dedo. Arq. anat., 1933-34, 16: 445-63, 12 pl. ---- Palm: Fascial contracture IDupuytren] AxToxirs, J. M. *l"ntersuchungen iibor histologische und klinische Befunde bei Dupuy- trenscher Fingerkontraktur. 36p. 8? Tub., 1927. Breitwieser, O. *Eine eigenartige Beobach- tung von Dupuvtrenscher Fingerkontraktur. 21 p. 8? Wiirzb." 193."). Le Becq, P. *Note sur la maladie de Dupuy- tren. 150p. 8? Par., 1928. Reimold, G. *Die Dupuytrcn'schc Finger- kontraktur [Heidelberg] 24p. 21 cm. ttpever, 1938. Adams, H. I). Dupuytren's cunt iacture. Lahey Clin. Bull., 1940-41, 2: 75-8.—Antonioli, G. M. Sulla malattia di Dupuy- tren (contributo clinico ed istologico) Ann. ital. chir., 1927, 6: 1011-37.—Bergel, I). Zur Frage der Dienstbeschadigung bei Dupuvtrenscher Kontraktur. Med. Welt, 1935, 10: 16-8.— Beul, A. P., & Kocan, A. V. [I'seudo-Dupuytren contracture] Khirurgia, Moskva. 1937. No. 3, 98-102.—Beyoul, A. La maladie de Dupuytren. Rev. chir., Par., 1935, 73: 351-7.— Hinda, P. Sulla contrattura di Dupuytren. Gazz. med. ital., 1912. 63: 21 5. -Brockman, E. P. Dupuytren's contraction. In Hut. Kncwl. M. Pi-act. (Rolleston, H.) Lond., 1937, 4: -72 6. Coenen, H. Die Dupuytrensche Fingerkontraktur. Med. Klin., 1935, 31: 1657-61.—Couceiro, A. Um caso de doenea de Dupuytren; contribuicao ao estudo da assim chamada retracao da aponevrose palmar. Neurobiologia, Recife, 1940, 3: 396—403—Dupuytren. Permanent retraction of the fingers, produced by an aIIeel ion of the palmar fascia; clinical lectures on surgerv, given at the Hotel Dieu, Paris. Med. Classics, 1939-40, 4: 142-50.- - Dutto. U. Sul morbo di Dupuytren. Gazz. med., Roma, 1928, 54: 198.—Ely, L. W. Dupuytren's contraction Surg. Clin. X. America, 1926, 6: 421-4. Also In Cyclop. -Med. (Pieisol-Burtz) Phila., 1939, 5: 233-7— Fino- chietto, E., Castillo Odena. I., & Tesone, J. D. Manifi staciones aberrantes de la enfermedad de Dupuytren; retraccion de la aponeurosis palmar. Prensa med. argent., 1940, 27: fit 2, 1421-4.—Gill, A. B. Dupuvtren'.- contracture. \nn Sur" 1938. 107: 122-7.—Harper, W. F. The distribution of the palmar aponeurosis in relation to Dupuytren's contraction of the thumb. J. Anat., Lond., 1934-35. 69: 193-5.—Kaplan, E. B. The palmar fascia in connection with Dupuvtren's con- tracture. Surgery, 1938, 4: 415-22.—Hosier, S. Un cas inteiessant de retraction bilaterale de l'aponevrose palmaire de Dupuytren. Rev. neur., Par., 1935, 42: 281-5.------ [Extraordinary case of bilateral Dupuvtien contracture] Ned tschr. geneesk., 1935, 79: 674-8, pl.—Marin Gatica, J. Enfer- Dupu.vtren. Rev. med. Chile, 1939, 67: 1221-32.— Su di un ca-o di morbo del Dupuvtren. Gior. 76: 600-2.- Mazzoni, E. Sul morbo di Dupuv- 55: 1323-9.—Meyerding, H. W. Arch- Surg., 1(j36| 32: 320-33. — & Overton, L. Ibid., 801-3 iedad de Massarotti, G. med. mil., 1928 iron. Gazz. osp., 1934, Dupuytren's contracture. Also Proc. Mayo Clin., 1935, 10: 694-6. - M. Bilateral Dupuytren's contracture. Oehlecker, F. Ueber Dupuytrensche Fingerkontraktui Beitr. klin. Chir., 1930, 149: 333-64— Palmer, G. Maladie de Dupuytren; retraction de l'aponevrose palmaire Gaz hop 1933, 106: 1369-75.- Pardo-Castello, V. Contraction of the" palmar aponeurosis (Dupuytren- disease; Acta derm vener Stockh., 1932-33, 13: 649-54.—Picard, J. Quelques donnees sur la maladie de Dupuytren. Vie med., 1927, 8: 225-8__ Pilon, A. Deux observations ,-u.r la maladie de Dupuvtren J. Hotel Dieu. Montreal, 1936, 5: 75-81 .-Riedl. I. Dr, is^g licoliachtcte Falle Dupuylien'sch.i Kontraktur in dor Zeit von 1932 lus 1938. Zbl. Chi... 1939, 66: 1093-6.—Rodriguez Villegas, K.. A: Brarhetto-IJrian. I). Retracci6n de la aponeuro- sis palinai superficial; enfeimeilad de Dupuvtren. Bol. Soc. cir. B. Aires, 1930, 14: 809 21.- Koutier. A propos de la retraction de l'aponevrose palmaire. Bull. Soc. nat. chir., l'ar., 1931 57: 1467.—Ruiz Moreno, A. Enfermedad de Dupuytren v dedo a lesort.e. Semana med.. B. Air., 1936, 43: 939-46. - Savarese, K. La malattia di Dupuytren. Clin, chir., Milano, 1935, n. ser., 11: 583--005. —Share-Jones. J. Dupuytren's contraction. Vet. Rec, Lond., 1932, 12: 877. -Tuma, V. Kin Versueh der Zuchtung des Gewel.esaus der Dupuytrensclien Kontraktur des erwaehsenen Menschen. Arch. exp. Zellforsch., 1934, 15: 173-8. — llngureanu, V. [Clinical case of Dupuvtren's contracture] Cluj. med., 1929, 10: 522-4.—Vinar, J. Cas d'acrocontracture. Rev. neur., Par., 1936, 65: 855. Wuin- wright, L. Dupuytren's contraction. Practitioner, Lond.. 1929, 117: 263-5.—Weber, F. P. A note on Dupuytren's contiaci n.n, camptodactylia and knuckle-pads. Brit. J. Derm. Syph., 1938, 50: 26-31.—Zierold, A. A. Dupuvtren's contracture. Minne- sota M., 1934, 17: 159. ---- Palm: Fascial contracture: Etiology. Aijello, D. A. *La maladie de Dupuytren et ses rapports avec la glande paratliyroide [Geneve] 36p. 8? Annemasse, 1933. Bohme, H. *Zur Aetiologie der Dupuytren'- schen Fingerkonliaklur [Freiburg] 29p. 8? Gliickstadt [1930] Gilbeau, W. *Dui>uvtren'sche Kontraktur und Unfall [Bonn] 24p."8! Diisseld., 1934. Maire, R. *Contribution a l'etiologie nerveuse de certaines retractions de l'aponevrose palmaire; les maladies de Dupuytren d'origine nerveuse. 150p. 5 pl. 8? Par., 1932. Porten, G. von der. *Zur Aetiologie der Dupuytren'schen Kontraktur [Zurich] 24p. 22>/2cm. Schaan, 1938. Portius, W. * Untersuchungen zur Frage der Dupuytren'schen Fingerkontraktur und des muskularen Schiefhalses [Kiel] 31p. 8? Diis- seld., 1936. Reissmann, K. *Ueber Aetiologie und thcra- peutische Ergebnisse der Dupuytrensclien Finger- kontraktur. 34p. 23cm. Berl., 1937. Stackebrandt, H. *Die Hereditat bei dor Dupuytrenschen Kontraktur, dargestellt an 5 Stammbaumen [Munster] 32p. S? Nordon, 1932. Wolf, J. *Ueber Vorkommen und Bedeutung der Dupuytrenschen Kontraktur bei Nerven- krankheiten. 16p. 8? Basel, 1935. Boulogne. Deux observations concordantes pour une §tiologie de la maladie de Dupuytren. Rev. neur., Par., 1935, 42: 991.—Boulogne, P. Retraction symetrique des aponeuroses palmaires par ectasie de l'aorte. Bull, med., Par., 1920, 40: 201.—Chatagnon. P., Soulairac, A., & Chatagnon, C. Maladie de Dupuytren chez une melancolique. Ann. med. psychol., 201.—Chatagnon, P., Soulairac, A., & Chatagnon, C. Maladie de Dupuytren chez une melancolique. Ann. med. psychol Par., 1938, 96: pt 2, 238-45. Constantinescu. M., Tuchel, V., & Coraciu, G. Ueber einen Fall von angeborener doppelseitiger Dupuytren'scher Kontraktur. Zbl. Chir., 1938, 65: 191-4. - Couch, H. Identical Dupuvtren's contracture in identical twins. Canad. M. Ass. J., 1938, 39: 225.—Csorsz, K. [Predis- position to Dupuytren's contracture in families] Budapesti orv. ujs., 1930, 28: 59-61.—Davis, J. S., & Finesilver, K. M. Dupuytren's contraction, with a note on the incidence! of the contraction in diabetes. Arch. Surg., 1932, 24: 933-89-- Debrunner, H. Sippschaftstabelle einer Familie mit Dupu\- trenscher Kontraktur. Zschr. orthop. Chir., 1934-35, 62: 321-3.—Deckner, K. Wesen und Behandlung der Dupuv- trenschen Fingerkontraktur. Ther. Gegenwart, 1939, 80: 69-72.—Decref, J. La enfermedad llamada de Dupuytren o retracci6n de la aponeurosis palmar, ;,puede ser eonsiderada como un accidente del trabajo o como una enfermedad pro- fessional? Siglo med., 1929, 83: 569.—Devoto, L. La retra- zione della palma della mano e della pianta del piede (sulla etiopatogenesi della malattia di Dupuytren) Med. lavoro, l.i-j. 16: 407-10.—Dusatti, C. Con.siderazioni patogenetiche su un caso di morbo di Dupuytren. Minerva med., Tor., 1936, 27: pt 2, 79.—Ferrarini, M. Sulla anatomia patologica 'es ulla ?oQ,?a^gene1,,^ello:rnal:lttia del Dupuytren. Arch. ital. chir., ZZ ' o J • Also <;'or- At:cad. med. Torino, 1939, 102: l6'< P* 2> 4P: ------ Se la malattia del Dupuytren possa essere considerata quale una malattia professionale. Pass. med. indust 1940, II: 70-97. Frcdet. P. A propos apique de la maladie de Dupuytren. Arch, electr. meU, 1925, 35: 64-6.—Stahnke, E. Zur Be- handlung der Dupuytren'schen Fingerkontraktur. Zbl. Chir., 1927, 54: 2438-42.—Tobiasek [Tobiasek's method of operation of Dupuytren's contracture of the fingers] Cas. \ik. 6esk., 1930, 69: 421-59.—Tomanek, F. [Radium therapy in Dupuytren's contracture] Ibid., 1935, 74: 46.—Wagner, W. HAND HAND Ergebnisse der operativen Behandlung bei Dupuytrenseher Kontraktur. Beitr. klin. Chir., 1932, 155: 271-4. ---- Paralysis. See also Hemiplegia; Paraplegia; and names of primarv diseases. Bidon". Le signe de Raimiste (phenomene de la main) Marseille mid., 1910, 48: 417-20.—Cole, W. Silk ligament suspension of both hands for paralysis of their extensor muscles. S. Paul M. J., 1916, 18: 25.—Cucchi, A. Sopra un caso con- troverso di paresi post-traumatica della mano (nota casistica) Gior. clin. med., 1938, 19: 109-13.—Dodd, H. Paralysis of the right posterior interosseous nerve. Lancet, Lond., 1934, 1: 20-2.—Edwards, H. Posterior interosseous paralysis. Proc. R. Soc. M., Lond., 1935-36, 29: 1225.—Fitch, R. R. An operation to improve the condition of hands disabled by paralysis of the opponens pollicis. J. Bone Surg., 1930, 12: 190.—Hall, M. The condition of the hemiplegic hand. In Hall (M.) Pract. Obs. & Suggestions, Lond., 1846, 2. ser., 71 — Hobhouse, N., & Heald, C. B. A case of posterior interosseous paralysis. Brit. M. J., 1936, 1: 841.—Hue, G., & Iselin, M. Paralysies des nerfs de la main. In Traite' chir. orthop. (Om- bre^lanne) Par., 1937, 3: 2840-71—Kohler, F. Schulung und Leistung Handgelahmter in der Kruppelschule. Zschr. Kruppelfurs., 1937, 30: 112-23.—Krida, A. Multiple tendon transplantations for combined median and ulnar paralysis. Internat. J. Surg., 1926, 39: 342-4.—Luft, L. Eine Schiene zur Verhutung und Behandlung bei Interosseuslahmung. Munch, med. Wschr., 1916, 63: 698.—Lyle, H. H. M. The operative treatment of thenar paralysis. Ann. Surg., 1926, 84: 288-94.—Steindler, A. flexor plasty of the thumb in thenar palsy. Surg. Cyn. Obst., 1930, 50: 1005-7.—Teece, I.. G. Tendon transplantation for dorsal interosseous paralysis. Med. J. Australia, 1919, 2: 131.—Weil, S. Operative Behand- lung der sogenannten Opponensliihmung. Klin. Wschr., 1926, 5: 650.—Weinberger, L. M. Non-traumatic paralysis of the dorsal interosseous nerve. Surg. Gyn. Obst., 1939, 69: 358- 63.—Woltman, H. W. Progressive paralysis of the nervus interosseus dorsalis. Brain, Lond., 1934, 57: 25-31. ---- Psychological aspect. Giese, F. Psychologie der Arbeitshand. p.803-1124. 8? Berl., 1935. Handb. biol. Arbeitsmeth. (Abderhalden, E.) Berl., 1935, 6: Avalon, J. Le geste de la figue. Aesculape, Par., 1934, 24: 84-90.—Carmichael, L., Roberts, S. O., & Wessell, N. Y. A study of the judgment of manual expression as presented in still and motion pictures. J. Social Psychol., 1937, 8: 115-42.— Friedjung, J. Zur Ontogenese der Betatigung der Hande und ihren Storungen. Zschr. Kinderpsychiat., Basel, 1940, 7: 65-70.—Fiirst, T. Hand und Beruf. Hippokrates, Stuttg., 1936, 7: 1225-8.—Raspail, F. V. Physiognomonie, physio- gnomic ou physionomie de la main. Rev. compl. sc. appl. mid., Par., 1854-55, 1: 93-7.—Revesz, G. La fonction soci- ologique de la main humaine et de la main animale. J. psychol. norm, path., Par., 1938, 35: 26-49.—Taylor, J. H. The rela- tionship between finger length, hand width and musical ability. J. Appl. Psychol., 1936, 20, 3: 347-52.—ValSik, J. A. [Is there any correlation between the intelligence of normal persons and the dermohypsomatological formations of their palms] Anthropologie, Praha, 1929, 7: 308-18.—Zenneck, I. Die Bildung der menschlichen Hand als Ausdruck des Habitus; anatomisch-photographische Reihenuntersuchungen zur Kon- stitutionspathologie. Zschr. menschl. Vererb., 1939, 23: 67-93. ---- Radiology. Dam, C. van [Roentgenography of the hand] Ned. tschr. geneesk., 1937, 81: 2397-9.—Janker, R. Eine verkannte Projektion des Erbsenbeins; ein folgenschwerer Rontgenirrtum. Chirurg, 1934, 6: 544-7.—Rathcke, L. Rontgenologische Irrtiimer durch Fehlprojektion. Zbl. Chir., 1936, 63: 2826-9 — Tomslk, L. [New method for skiagraphic examination of thumb and of the first metacarpus] Voj. zdrav. listy, 1931, 7: 179-82. ---- Reflexes. Zajdorf, A. *Das Fingerbeugephanomen und seine Beziehungen zu anderen pathologischen Reflexen [Basel] 31p. 24cm. Kalisz, 1937. Zixxer, K. *Ueber das Wartenbergsche Pyramidenzeichen an der Hand [Freiburg] p.411-9. 8? Berl., 1930. Also Arch. Psychiat., Berl., 1930, 92: Balaban, I. M. [Marinesco-RadovhM reflex and its clinical significance] Sovet. nevropat., 1935, 4: No. 8, 101-12.— Becher, H. Fingerspreizphanomen im Kindesalter, hervor- gerufen durch weites Mundoffnen. Wien. klin. Wschr., 1932, 45: 1155.—Cooper, M. J. Mechanical factors governing the Tromner reflex. Arch. Neur. Psychiat., Chic, 1933, 30: 166-9.—Coppa, E. Contributo alio studio della reflettivitS della mano in condizioni patologiche. Cervello, 1928, 7: 164-77.—Dagnini, G. Riflesso di estensione della mano nelle lesioni delle vie piramidali. Bull. sc. med., Bologna, 1933, 105: 142-4—Dosuzkov, T. Ueber den Streclueflex der basalen Fingergelenke. Fol. neuropath, eston., 1936, 15: & 16: 104- 13.—Dumpert, V. Entgegnung auf C. Mayers Bemerkungen zu meiner Arbeit iiber den Fingerdaumenreflex. J. Psychol. Neur., Lpz., 1922-23, 29: 128-32.—Fay, T., & Gotten. H. B. Clinical observations on the value of the Hoffmann sign. J. Nerv. Ment. Dis., 1933, 77: 594-600.—Golla, F., & Antono- vitch, S. A note on the palmar chin reflex of Marinesco. J. Ment. Sc, Lond., 1934, 80: 513-20- Grossman, J. [Com- pressometer for investigation of the finger-pain reflex] Vrach. gaz., 1927, 31: 1817.—Griinbaum, A. A. The pointing position of the hand as a pathological and primitive reflex. Brain, Lond., 1930, 53: 267-77.—Hilden, A. H. An action current study of the conditioned hand withdrawal. Psychol. Monogr., 1937, 49: 173-204.—Johnsson, Vera. [Research on reflex of the hand, described by Sterling] Hygiea, Stockh., 1935, 97: 401-10.—Juster, E. Le reflexe cutane' hypothenarien, signe de Babinski de la main. Presse meU, 1927, 35: 759.—Kaslein, G. W. [Nature and origin of reflexes of the type of Troemner, Hoffmann, Rossolimo and Zukowski] Ned. tschr. geneesk., 1936, 80: 1187-94.—Kempner. Ueber eine Art Mctidelschen Reflexes an der Hand. Klin. Wschr., 1926, 5: 1255.- Magnus- son, J. H., & Wernstedt, W. The infantile palmo-mental reflex. Acta paediat., Upps., 1935, 17: Suppl. 1, 241-5.— Mayer, C. Bemerkungen zu V. Dumperts Arbeit: Kritisches zu dem nach C. Mayer benannten Finger-Daumenreflex. J. Psychol. Neur., Lpz., 1921-22, 27: 313-5.—Mayer, K. Der Hypothenarhautreflex (Juster) ein spastisches Zeichen an der Hand. Zschr. ges. Neur. Psychiat., 1932, 138: 131-9 — Peremy, G. Ueber den diagnostischen Wert des Handreflexes von Juster. Deut. Zschr. Nervenh., 1929, 109: 77-83 — Perria, L. Sul segno di Mayer. Note psichiat., Pesaro, 1939, 68: 295-322.—Pitfield, R. L. The Hoffman reflex; a simple way of reinforcing it and other reflexes. J. Nerv. Ment. Dis., 1929, 69: 252-8.—Pool, J. L. Manual reflex; the ulnar adductor reflex. Bull. Neur. Inst. N. York, 1937, 6: 372-7—S&inz, E. G. La flexi6n dorsal de los dedos (signo de Masini) en el nifio. Gac med. catal., Barcel., 1909, 34: 241-8.—Sanford, H. N. The Moro reflex in the new-born. Am. J. Dis. Child., 1933, 46: 337-40.—Sarno, D. Sul riflesso palmo-mentoniero. Neurologica, Nap., 1926, 3: 321-32.—Schachter-Nancy. Le reflexe palmo-mentonnier (Marinesco-Radovici) chez l'enfant. Rev. fr. pediat., 1937, 13: 180-6.—Schachter, M. Un reflexe associatif k caractdre regressif chez l'enfant: l'ecartement des doigts de la main pendant l'ouverture de la bouche. Clin. pediat.. Mod., 1935, 17: 433-40. ■------ & Nedler, D. Un reflexe chez l'enfant; l'ecartement des doigts pendant l'ouver- ture de la bouche. Bull, med., Par., 1933, 47: 117-9.—Sterling, W. Les pMnomenes des doigts analogues aux signes de Babins- ki et de Rossolimo. Rev. neur., Par., 1926, 33: pt 2, 82-8.— Torsegno, M. E. Reflejo de la articulaci6n de la mufieca y reflejo de la articulaci6n basal. Arch, med., Madr., 1935, 38: 320-31. ------ Breve nota sobre algunos reflejos de la mano. Ibid., 426-9.—Wernjfe, T. B. [The inhibitive finger reflex] Hospitalstidende, 1927, 70: 493-504.—Wickens, D. D. A study of voluntary and involuntary finger conditioning. J. Exp. Psychol., 1939, 25: 127-40. ---- Sarcoma. (hauvenet, A., & Laumonier, P. Disarticulation d'urgence de l'epaule avec curettage axillaire pour tumeur melanique du poignet. Bordeaux chir., 1937, 8: 27-30.—Driessens, J., & Bastien, P. Sarcome fibroblastique de l'os de la deuxifime phalange de l'auriculaire. Ann. anat. path., Par., 1939, 16: 88-90.—Silvestrini, L. Trauma e tumore; a proposito di un melanoblastoma maligno, insorto in seguito a grave ferita della mano, riportata sul lavoro. Chir. org. movim., 1935-36, 21: 36-64.-—Simenstad, L. O. Spindle-cell sarcoma of the hand following continued irritation. Internat. J. M. & S., 1930, 43: 431-4/—Thies, O. Sarkom nach Kriegsverletzung. Zbl. Chir., 1936, 63: 1763-70. ---- Surgery. Couch, J. H. Surgery of the hand; some prac- tical aspects. 147p. 21cm. [Toronto] 1939. Hart, D. Surgery of the hand, p.891-958. 8? N. Y., 1934. In Pract. Libr. M. & S. (Appleton) N. Y., 1934, 5: Iselin, M. Plaies et maladies infectieuses des mains. 217p. 23cm. Par., 1928. ---- Chirurgie de la main; plaies, infections et chirurgie reparatrice. 339p. 8? Par., 1933. ---- Chirurgie de la main [Rev. ed.] 320p. 25#cm. Par., 1938. ----The same. Surgery of the hand; wounds, infections and closed traumata. 353p. 23cm. Lond., 1940. Nicolas, R. *L'arthrodese extra-articulaire du poignet. 70p. 25/2cm. Lyon, 1939. Rehn, E. Die Chirurgie des Handgelenkes und der Hand, p.405-563. 8? Stuttg., 1922. In Handb. prakt. Chir. (C. Garre & H. Kuttner) 5. Aufl., Stuttg., 1922, 5: HAND 69 HAND Starfinger, U. *Beitrage zur kleinen Chirur- gie an Hand und Fingern und ihre Resultate. 31p. 20}/2cm. Konigsb., 1935. Bunnell, S. Surgery of the nerves of the hand. Surg. Gyn. Obst., 1927, 44: 145-52.—Dzhanelidze, U. U. [Restoration of the flexion of the fingers by Sterling-Bunnel's method] Vest. khir., 1930, 19: 39-53.—Forgue, E. L'operation de Dujardin- Beaumetz dans les lesions accidentelles des doigts et la restaura- tion fonctionnelle des mains mutilees. Progr. med., Par., 1936, 305-9.—Friedland, M. O., & Tsiporkin, L. O. [Modified model of Mommsen's lyre] Ortop. travmat., 1937, 11: 103.—Grias. Reflexions sur la mobilisation des doigts. Arch. med. Angers, 1938, 42: 55-9.—Harmer, T. W. Certain aspects of hand surgery. Tr. N. England Surg. Soc, 1935, 18: 217-29. Also N. England J. M., 1936, 214: 613-7.—Kanavel, A. B. Surgery of the hand. Proc. Interst. Postgrad. M. Ass. N. America, (1929) 1930, 5: 28-34, 8 pl.—Ki«r, S. [Anatomic observations on the surgery of the hand] Ugeskr. lager, 1930, 92: 755-64.— Model, R. Gegluckte Naht einer abgehackten Fingerspitze unter Unguentolanverband. Munch, med. Wschr., 1936, 83: 1355.—Pauchet, V., Sourdat, P., & Labat, G. Anesthesie des doigts et de la main. Clinique, Par., 1925, 20: 218-22.— Popovici, V. M. Une nouvelle incision pour la ligature des arcades palmaires. Lyon chir., 1929, 26: 686-93.—Rieder, W. Resektion der zur Hand gehenden Rami communicantes. Chirurg, 1933, 5: 219-24.—Salsbury, C. R. Some practical points in hand surgery. J. Oklahoma M. Ass., 1933, 26: 315- 9.—Seara, P. Tratamiento de los panadizos 6seos. Prensa med. argent., 1935, 22: 99-16.—Shargorodskay, J. J. [Ra- tional way of bandaging the palmar arches] Vest, khir., 1928, 13: No. 37-38, 150-7.—Shirokov, B. A. [Phalangization of the 1st metacarpal bone and anatomical principles of the author's method] Khirurgia, Moskva, 1939, No. 7, 115-22.—Young, F. Surgical repair of the long-disabled hand. Surg. Gyn. Obst., 1938, 67: 73-81. ---- Surgery, plastic. Aust, F. P. A. W. *Ueber Hautplastik an Hand und Fingern unter Heranziehung eines Fades von Muffplastik. 21p. 8? Lpz., 1926. Blair, V. P., & Byars, L. T. Toe to finger transplant. Tr. South. Surg. Ass. (1939) 1940, 52: 465-8.—Bonnet, P. Trau- matisme de la main avec perte de substance du ler espace interosseux; conservation primitive systematique; cheiroplastie secondaire utilisant les teguments de l'index conserve dans ce but; phalangisation du ler metacarpien. Lyon chir., 1929, 26: 260.—Brown, J. B. Surface defects of the hand. Am. J. Surg., 1939, 46: 690-9.—Burman, M. S. Vitallium cap arthroplasty of metacarpophalangeal and interphalangeal joints of the fingers. Bull. Hosp. Joint Dis., 1940, 1: 78-89.—Buzello, A. Umstellungsplastik des Zeigefingers bei Verlust des ganzen Daumens. Zbl. Chir., 1936, 63: 2945-52.—Chauvenet, A. Autoplastic de la main par lambeaux digitaux. Bordeaux chir., 1935, 6: 18-25.—Dzbanovsky, V. P. [Transplantation of a toe to the hand] Vest, khir., 1938, 55: 626-9.—Esser, J. F. S., & Ranschburg, P. Reconstruction of a hand and 4 fingers by transplantation of the middle part of the foot and 4 toes. Ann. Surg., 1940, 111: 655-9.—Faltin, R. [Phalangization of the metacarpal bone in combination with round stylus plastic in loss of thumbs and skin of both hands] Nord. med., 1939, 2: 1412-5.—Haas, S. L. Plastic restoration for loss of all fingers of both hands. Am. J. Surg., 1937, 36: 720-3.—Kitlowski, E. A. The preservation of tendon function by the use of skin flaps. Ibid., 1941, 51: 653-61.—Lepoutre. Autoplastic de la main par desossement d'un doigt. J. sc. mid. Lille, 1920, 38: pt 1, 75-7.—Mason, M. L. Plastic surgery of the hands. Surg. Clin. N. America, 1939, 19: 227-48. ------ Plastic surgery and repair, with particular reference to the repair of cutaneous defects of the hand. Indust. M., 1941, 10: 47-52.—O'Connor, G. B. Glove flap method of dorsal hand repair. Am. J. Surg., 1936, 32: 44.5-7, 5 pl. Also Rev. chir. struct., Par., 1936-37, 6: 384-90. ------ An operation for dorsal hand reconstruction. Pacific Coast M„ 1937, 4: 28-30.------& Pierce, G. W. Pedicle flap patterns for hand reconstruction. Rev. chir. struct., Brux., 1937, 7: 85-90. Also Surg. Gyn. Obst., 1937, 65: 523-7.—Seiffert, K. Hand- und Fingerplastiken. Arch. orthop. UnfaUchir., 1930, 28: 370-5.—Zollinger, A. Der Finger- ersatz mit besonderer Beriicksichtigung der Spalthandbildung. Deut. Zschr. Chir., 1926, 196: 271-87. ---- Tendons, and tendonsheaths. Besson, A., & Leplus, J. De la desinsertion phalangettienne du tendon extenseur; 6 nouveaux cas. J. sc. med. Lille, 1913, 36: 209-20, pl.—Correia, F. Les premieres anomalies anatomi- ques enregistrees sur les cadavres des Indo-Portugais; l'existence de deux filets tendineux surnumeraires sur le flechisseur com- mun superficiel ou flechisseur sublime des doigts. Arq. Esc. med. cir. Nova Goa, 1928, ser. A, 332-4, pl.—Hauck, G. Ein Beitrag zur Anatomie und Physiologie der Finger- und Hand- gelenk-Sehnenscheiden. Arch. klin. Chir., 1925, 136: 150-60 — Hughes-Jones, W. E. A. The synovial sheaths and fascial spaces of the hand. Med. J. Australia, 1933, 2: 658-60.— Leplat, G. De la gaine des fibres tendineuses et des anneaux de Henle. C. rend. Soc. biol., 1934, 117: 1205-7.—Lyle, F. M. Radiation treatment of ganglia of the wrist and hand. J. Bone Surg., 1941,23: 162. ---- Tendons, and tendonsheaths: Disease, and injury. Camard, J. *Les tumeurs a cellules geantes des gaines tendineuses digitales. 61p. 8? Par., 1932. Deicke, H. *Sehnenscheidenpanaritien der Hand, ihre Behandlung und ihr Spatschicksal [Leipzig] 24p. 8? Berl., 1933. Also Beitr. klin. Chir., 1933, 158: GellIs, X. *Traitement des tenosynovites aigues carpiennes et digitales par l'incision a minima. 103p. 8? Par., 1936. Jacobsohn, A. *Ueber subcutane Zerreissun- gen der langen Fingerstrecksehne. 54p. 8? Berl., 1919. Lagardere, J. *Etiologie, etude anatomo- clinique et therapeutique des infections aigues suppur^es des synoviales digitales des flechisseurs; possibilites et valeur du traitement conservateur. 109p. 8? Lyon, 1935. Moreatj, M. *A propos de deux cas de phleg- mons des gaines de la main gu6ris par l'immobili- sation platree. 30p. 24cm. Par., 1939. Adenot. Rupture probable d'un tendon flechisseur du mfidius 4 mois apres une contusion dans la region palmaire. Lyon med., 1912, 119: 385.—Alvisatos. Traitement des plaies des tendons de la main. P. verb. Congr. fr. chir., 1929, 38: 697-700.—Arnaud, L. Traitement des plaies des tendons de la main. Ibid., 712-7.—Avoni, A. Fibroma della guaina del tendine flessore profondo del dito anulare destro. Chir. org. movim., 1925, 9: 629-33.—Beckerman, L. S. [Suppurative inflammatory processes of the tendon sheaths, deep phlegmons of the hand and ascending phlegmons of the fore-arm] Vest. khir., 1938, 55: 445-64.—Betts, L. O. Injuries of the flexor tendons of the hand. Med. J. Australia, 1940, 2: 457-60.— Blagovidov, F. J. [Tendovaginitis crepitans as professional disease of moulders in manual brick industry] Vrach. delo, 1927, 10: 361.—Bloch, J. C, & Bonnet, P. Evolution et traite- ment des plaies des tendons de la main. P. verb. Congr. fr. chir., 1929, 38: 547-697. Also Gaz. hop., 1929, 102: 1581.— Bloch, J. C, & Zagdoun, J. Le traitement des plaies digitales des tendons flechisseurs (operation de St Bunnell) technique et resultats. J. chir., Par., 1936, 47: 376-91.—Braine, J, Phleg- mon total des gaines synoviales des flechisseurs de la main gauche; incision antibrachiopalmaire; guerison avec restitution fonctionnelle remarquable. Bull. Soc. nat. chir., Par., 1928, 54: 524-9.—Brenckmann, E., & Jung, A. Chondromas des gaines des flechisseurs de la main. Rev. orthop., Par., 1929, 3. ser., 16: 176-80.—Buisine, A. Un cas de phlegmon des gaines synoviales de la main. J. sc. med. Lille, 1922, 40: pt 2, 290-3.—■ Bunnell, S. Treatment of tendons in compound injuries of the hand. J. Bone Surg., 1941, 23: 240-50.—Cadenat, F. M. Le phlegmon des gaines des flechisseurs; comment le reconnaitre, comment le traiter? H6pital, 1927, 15: 106-8. ------ A propos du traitement des teno-synovites digitales. Bull. Soc. nat. chir., Par., 1931, 57: 522.—Cazin, M. Evolution et traite- ment des plaies des tendons de la main et des doigts. Paris chir., 1929, 21: 179-90.—Costescu, Tudor [et al.] Phlegmons des gaines de la main traites par incisions laterales et discon- tinues. Bull. Soc. nat. chir., Par., 1934, 60: 390-5.—Delbet, P. Phlegmon de la gaine du flechisseur du pouce traite par la vaccinoth6rapie. Ibid., 1928, 54: 666-72.—Derobert, L. Teno-synovite des extenseurs de la main et du pouce chez un ouvrier employe k feuillarder des caisses. Ann. med. leg., 1937, 17: 1147-9.—Devenish, E. A. Haematoma of the flexor tendon sheaths of the hand following penetrating wounds. Lancet, Lond., 1939, 1: 447.—Drescher, K. Ueber Endausgange der Sehnenscheidenphlegmone auf Grund von 107 Fallen aus der chirurgischen Universitatsklinik Konigsberg i. Pr. Arch. klin. Chir., 1936, 185: 504-7.—Dzhanelidze, U. U. [Treatment of injuries of the tendons of the hand] Nov. khir. arkh., 1936, 36: 497-507.—Favreau, J. C. Synovites aigues des gaines de la main. Union med. Canada, 1939, 68: 513.—Gigarella, J. Section des tendons flechisseurs de la main; suture. Marseille med., 1936,73: 725-7.—Garcia-Capurro, R. Procesos supurados de las vainas sinoviales de los dedos. Arch. urug. med., 1934, 5: 440.—Garlock, J. H. Management of injuries of the tendons and nerves of the hand. N. York State J. M., 1936, 36: 1740- 8.—Gontermann. Ein seltener Fall von subkutanem Abriss der Sehne des Muse flex. poll. long, vom Muskelfleisch. Mschr. Unfallh., 1929, 36: 546-9.—Grinnell, R. S. Acute suppurative tenosynovitis of the flexor tendon sheaths of the hand; a review of 125 cases. Ann. Surg., 1937, 105: 97-119.— Gruet, E. Suites eioign6es des sections tendineuses non sutures au niveau des doigts. Caduce, Par., 1913, 13: 45.—Gusev, B. N. [Clinical aspect of tendovaginitis in workers that use the wrist and fingers in their occupation] Nov. khir. arkh., 1936, 37: 397-402.—Guyot, J. Evolution et traitement des plaies des tendons de la main. P. verb. Congr. fr. chir., 1929, 38: 704-6.—Hartmann. Synovite chronique de la gaine du medius. Rev. gin. clin. ther., 1927, 41: 563.—Heineke. Spontanruptur MAM) 70 HAND der Sohne des langon Daumenstreckers. Miinch. med. Wschr., 1913, 60: 560.- Hesse. F. Die Behandlung von Sehnenverlet- zungen innerhalh s\ novialor Schciden entsprechend dem Sitz der Yerletzung im Bcreicli der Hohlhand und der Finger- beugesehnen; iiber die Verwendung von Schaltmaterial bei Substanzverlust der Sehne. Arch. klin. Chir., 1932, 170: 772- v.i. -Honigsmann, I'. Die t > annul ische Spiitruptur der Sehne de- langon Daumenstreckers. Med. Klin., Boil . 1926, 22: 728- 31.- Hudacsek. E. Beitriige zur Kenntnis dei Knoehen- und (ielcnk-panaiilien und Selmeii-clieidenplilegmoncn. Beitr. klin. Chir.. 1935, 161: 264-72. Iselin. M. Note sur le traite- ment des tenosynovites digitales. Bull. Soc. nat. chir., Par., 1931.57:456-65. — Tenosvnovites digitales. Schweiz. mod. Wschr., 1932, 62: 1159-63.------& Tailhefer. A. Traitement des plaies tendineuses de la main et des delists. (iaz. hop., 1927, 100: 961-4,—Jobson, T. B. Cut tendons. Brit. M. J., 1941, 1: 138.—Khaitziss. G. M. [Anatomical grounds for the clinical treatment of tendovaginitis of the palm] Vest, khir., 1930, 19: 356-62.—Khurgin, M. A. [Late rupture of extensor pnllicis longus tendon] Ortop. travmat., 1930, 4: No. 5-6, 47--50.—Kirchenberger, A. Zur Frage der Behandlung des Abrisses einer Streeksehne vom Fingcrend- gliede. Med. Klin., Berl.. 1926, 22: 1640. —Klapp, R. Ver- vollkommnung der Schnittfuhrung bei der Sehnenscheiden- und Hohlhandphlegmone. Zbl. Chir., 1931, 58: 953.—Koch, S. L. Injuries of the nerves and tendons of the hand. J. Oklahoma M. Ass., 1933. 26: 323-8. Also Pennsylvania M. J., 193 1, 37: 555-7. Also Wisconsin M. J., 1934, 33: 655-61. Lacroix. J. V. Traumatic division of the deep flexor tendon below the inser- tion of the superficial digital flexor. Vet. J., Lond., 1917. 73: 12-5.—Lardennois. H. Les plaies des tendons de la main. P verb. Congr. fr. chir., 1929, 38: 717-9.—Laroyenne & Muyssonnier. Phlegmon de la gaine synoviale du cinquieme doigt, traite sans incision digitale. Lyon med., 1929, 143: 259-61. Laumonier. Tumeur k myeioplaxcs de la gaine du flechisseur du cinquieme doigt. Bordeaux chir., 1939, 10: 52.- Lee, H. S. van der & SchefTelaar Klots, T. [Spontaneous rupture of extensor pnllicis longus tendon] Geneesk. gids, 1929, 7: 1141; 1171, pl— Leibovici, R., & Iselin. M. Traite- ment des phlegmons des gainrs carpiennes par les incisions laterals et discontinues. J. chir., Par., 1931, 37: 358-87.— Leonte, C. Considerations sur le traitement des plaies de tendons de la main. P. verb Congr fr. chir.. 1929, 38: 700- 4.- -Levin, J. J. Three case- of unusual tendon injuries. S. Afr. M. J., 1939, 13: 29 33. Mallet-Guy. P. Phlegmon des L> gaines carpiennes des flechisseurs traite par les incisions laterales et discontinues. I..\ on chir.. 1932, 29: 736-40.— Mason, M. L. Rupture of tendons of the hand; with a study of extensor tendon insertions in the fingers. Surg. C.yn. Obst. 1930, 50: 611-24.------Injuries to nerves and tendons of the hand. J. Am. M. Ass., 1941, 116: 1375-9. Moure. P. A propos du traitement du phlegmon des gaines synoviales de la main. Bull. Soc. nat. chir., Par., 1928, 54: 572-6. Murphy, J. B. Chronic tendovaginitis of the extensor tendon of the thumb; excision of the tendon sheath with the underlying periosteum; new tendon-sheath made from pedicled flaps of fat Surg. Clin. Chicago, 1915, 4: 497-503, pl.—Nilsonne, H. [Tendinitis stenosans in abductor pollicis longus] Sven. lak tidn., 1933, 30: 822— Nitsche, F. Beitrag zu den Sportver- letzungen; Abriss des Trochanter minor beim Eislauf; Sehnen- ruptur des Extensor pollicis longus beim Steinstossen. Zbl Chir., 1935, 62: 1092-4.—Ory. M. Los incisions lateralisees dans les phlegmons des gaines de la main. Liege med., 1934, 27: 384-7.- O'Shea. M. C. Severed tendons and nerves of the hand and forearm. Ann. Surg., 1937, 105: 228-42.—Paitre, F. Traitement des phlegmons synoviaux et lymphangitiques de la main; importance pratique des donnees anatomiques nouvelles sur les espaces celluleux de la main et des doigts. Bull, med Par., 1929, 43: 1171-7.—Paris, M. Phlegmon streptococcique des 2 grandes gaines tendineuses de la main droite Liege mid 1930, 23: 137^2.—Pique, J. A., Brachetto-Brian, D., & Fasciolo, J. C. Tumores benignos de las vainas tendinosas digitales. Hev. ortop. traumat., B. Air., 1937-38, 7: 169-81.__ Pohl, H. Selmenscheidenstenose des Musculus extensor pollicis longus sinister. Med. Klin., Berl., 1936, 32: 1596.—Przewalski, B. Chirurgische Behandlung der akuten Infektionen der lingeibeugesehnen und uber ein zuverliissiges Hilfsmittel zur 1 nlerdnickung .ler Infektionsvirulenz; nach den klinischen Beobachtungen drs von mir verwalteten 17. Krankenhauses und den Resultaten anatomischer Erforschung im Institut dei Xormalanatomie in Charkow. Arch. klin. Chir., 1931-32 168- 399-421.- Pupovac. D. [Opera!iv geheilter Ruptur der Sehne des M. extensor pollicis longus] Wien. med. Wschr 1919 69- /97. Rieder. W Thrombophlebitis des Arctis volaris ven'osus profundus bei sehnenscheidenpatiantium als Sepsisherd. Zbl Chir., 1934 61: 691-3.-Rocher. H. L. Une forme tout a fait anormale de synovite bilaterale des extenseurs des doigts a degenerescence kystique intratendineuse, avec formation 'de grains mihaires a l'interieur des fibres tendineuses; dissociation hbnllaire; synovectomy totale bilaterale; guerison J med Bordeaux, 1940, 117: 83-7.-Rougemont.de & Carcasson*! A propos du traitement du phlegmon des gaines digitales Lyon med.. 1933, 152: 414-6— Rozov, V. I. [Injuries of the tendons of the fingers and wrist and their treatment] Vest khir 193,.34:9o-10o.-Salsbury,C.R. A consideration of the tendon- in hand injuries. Am. J. Surg., 1933 21- 354-7 Ak„ re ,r. .SchefTelaar Kioto T. (A rare affection of the palmaris hongu- undon] Ned. tschr. geneesk., 1927, 71: pt 2, 1382-4 - Schorcher. Die Behandlung der Sehnenscheidenentzunduii*cn der Finger und des Handgelenkes. Zschr arztl. Fortbild., 1937, 34: 432-6.—Stahel. W. 1'eber Sehncnverlct/un-cn der Hand. Schweiz. med. Wschr.. 1937, 67: 51 1. Straus. F. H . Luxation of extensor tendons in the hand. Ann. Surg., 19 10. Ill: 135- 40.-- - Struppler. V. Leber Xerven- und Sehnenverletzuugeii. Munch, med. Wschr.. 1934, 81: 703 5. Tuomikoski. V. Leber die Selmenscheidcn.stcnose an dem Processus stxloidcus radii Acta Soc. mod. Duodeeim, 1939, ser. B, 27: No. 24, I 5. Vialle, P. Traitement des phlegmons des gaines digito- palmaires. Aich. med. chir. Prov.mee. 1931, 21: 112 23. W'interstoin. (). Ueber Sehuenschiidc n.-lenosen am lland- gelenk. Schweiz. med. Wschr.. 192S. 58: 746- 8. Also In Festschrift F. de Quervain. Basel, I92H. 139 43. Wunsch, S. G. [Case of subcutaneous rupture of both flexors of I lie finger| Khirurgia, Moskva. 1938, No. 6, 151. ---- Tendons and tendonsheaths: Surgery. Ciuonti V. *Une nouvelle technique de reparation des tendons flechisseurs au niveau des doigts; technique du docteur Mont ant. 01 p. 24cm. Par., 1939. Schwartz, A. *Dic Erfolge der Sehnennahte an der Hand. 16p. 8? Basel, 1934. Tailhefer, E. M. A. *Les techniques et les rcsultats actuels de la reparation des tendons dc la main et des doigts. 95p. 8? Par., 1928. Albert, F. Le traitenieut des sections des tendons flechsi- seurs des doigts par la giell'e tendineuse. Ann. Soc. med. chir. Liege, 1930, 63: No. 9. 18-21. Also Liege med., 1930, 23: 1069-77.—Andresen, A. Section of the flexor tendons of the middle finger of the left hand through a palmar wound; primary suture and cure. J. Bone Surg., 1932, 14: 700.—Blanc, H. Section de 2 tendons extenseurs des doigts; suture tardive; guerison. Bull. Soc. chir. Paris, 1929, 21: 42.—Bloch, J. C. & Tailhefer, A. Contribution k l'etude de la reparation des ten- dons flechisseurs des doigts. Gaz. hop., 1929, 102: 5.—-Blum, L. Partial myotomy in the treatment of divided flexor tendons of the hand; a report of 2 cases. Ann. Surg., 1941, 113: 460-3.—Bove, C. Suturing of flexor tendons of the hand; transfixation. Med. Rec, N. Y., 1941, 153: 94. -Bunnell. S. Repair of nerves and tendons of the hand. .1. Bone Surg., I92S, 10: 1-26. Charbonnel. Resultat au cinquieme mois d'une suture primitive du nerf median et des tendons palmaires, flechisseurs superficiels et profonds sectionnes au poignet; guerison. Bordeaux chir., 1934, 5: 276.—Chianello, C. Sulla cura delle vaste ed antiche distruzioni dei tendini delle mani. Cult. med. mod., Pal., 1927, 6: 104 6— Chiarello, A. G. Contributo clinico alia oliirurgia riparatrice dei tendini e dei nervi della mano. Policlinico, 1932, 39: sez. prat., 520-5.— Cleveland. H. E. Repair of tendons of the hand. J. Lancet, 1939, 59: 524.—Cleveland, M. Restoration of the digital portion of a flexor tendon and sheath in the hand. J. Bone Surg., 1933, 15: 762-5.—Couch, J. H. The principles of tendon suture in the hands. Canad. M. Ass. J., 1939, 41: 27-30.— Cuneo, B., & Seneque, J. Section du tendon flechisseur pro- fond des 4<* et 5« doigts de la main droite a In base de ces doigts; operation de Sterling-Bunnell; resultat 5 mois apres. Bull Soc. nat. chir., Par., 1933, 59: 968.—Derra, E., & Ruberg. G. Spatergebnisse nach Sehnenoperationen im Bereich der Hand Mschr. Unfallh., 1938, 45: 305-15. Dubrov, I. G. [On free plastic surgery of the flexor tendons of the hand] Ortop travmat., 1941, 15: 66-74.—Garay, A. de. Seccion de los tendones de la tabaquera anatomica por instrumento punzo- cortante;ingertostendinosos autoplastics; exito. Mem Congr med. nac mex., 1910, 4. Congr., 284 (i. Garlock. J. H. Repair of wounds of the flexor tendons of the hand. Ann. Surg., 1926, 83: 111-22.—Gruet, E. Accident du travail, suites eioigneesdes sections tendineuses non sutures au niveau des doigts. Rev. med. leg 1913, 20: 110-2.—Heck, F. Spatergebnisse von Selmennahten an Arm und Hand. Arch, orthop. UnfaUchir., 1938, 39: 21 8. -Iselin, M. Reparation des tendons flechis- seurs sectionnes au niveau des doigts. J. chir., Par., 1927, 30: •'31-40. - ■ ■ - - Note sur la reparation des tendons flechisseurs des doigts d aprte 24 observations. Bull. Soc. nat. chir., Par., 1J31. o7: 122,-31.—Khaitziss, G. M. [Operative method in «P°'?Yre on the flexor te"dons of the hand] Vest, khir., 1930 22: Ho-20.—Ki»r, S. The invalidism after cutting of the tendons of the hand. Acta orthop. scand., 1931, 2: 202-20 — Koch, S L., & Mason M. L. Division of the nerves and ten- dons of the hand, with a discussion of the surgical treatment and its results. Surg. Gyn. Obst., 1933, 56: 1 -39 Lasserre (' Kocher H L. & Papin. Suture des llechisieurs k la paume; t6sultat. Bordeaux chir., 1932, 3:466. Masini. P. Involution et traitement des plaies des tendons de la main. P. verb Congr fr. chir. 1929. 38: 724-34.-Masmonteil, F. A propos des sutures et reconstitutions des tendons de la main. Bull. Soc. wf-^tS' A.9-36, i8:3P-84- Also J- m6d- Paris' 1936. 56 = M-:).-Mathieu, P Reimplantation terminale dun tendon Hechisseur profond du m6dius droit sectionn6; avantages de lomsation io<6e apres intervention. M6m. Acad, chir., Par., U36, 62: 1099. -Met.vet. G. Section des t»ndons flechisseurs Z 'f a '• ,"lpd"ls; s"t'"'e secondaire du tendon flechisseur sJtuT.J T' «'.""^"mique imparfait; resultat fonctionnel P-ih- w oUlL h?c- nat- chir- Par- 1929, 55: 702.- l-acher, W. Beugesehnenplastiken an der Hand mit einem tsutrag zur Opponenslahmung. Arch, orthop. UnfaUchir., HAND 71 HAND AND FOOT 1939-40, 40: 93-101.—Peugniez, P. Evolution et traitement iles plaies des tendons de la main. P. verb. Congr. fr. chir., 1929, 38: 719-23.—Prati, M. Sulla importanza delle giunture tendinee nelle lesioni dei tendini estensori delle dita. Arch. ital. chir., 1927, 17: 597-610.—Rivard, J. H. Sutures des tendons du flechisseur profond de la main; operation. Union med. Canada, 1930, 59: 28-30— Rocher, H. L. Reinsertion du tendon extenseur du medius sur la phalangine. Gaz. sc. med. Bordeaux, 1921, 42: 477.------Suture des tendons flechis- seurs des quatre derniers doigts a la paume de la main, partie movetine; suture seeondaire au septieme mois; bon resultat. Bordeaux chir., 1934, 5: 290.—Rozov, V. I. [Primary and secondary suture of ligaments of the flexors of the hand and fingers] Nov. khir. arkh., 1938, 41: 490-504.—Sani, F. Tre casi di tenotomia. Ann. med. chir., Roma, 1842, 7: 154-8.— Senechal, M. Mobilisation precoce apres suture des tendons de la main. P. verb. Congr. fr. chir., 1929, 38: 734-7.— Sterling-Bunnell. Greffes nerveuses et tendineuses de la main. Arch. fr. belg. chir., 1927, 30: 93-7.—Tailhefer, A. Suture primitive des 2 tendons flechisseurs du 4ed oigt dans la. region palmaire; suture de flechisseur profond de l'index dans la region palmaire. Bull. Soc. nat. chir., Par., 1928, 54: 827-9.— Walther. Section par eclat de verre du tendon du long flechis- seur propre du pouce; suture tardive par incision palmaire a grand lambeau. Bull. Soc. chir. Paris, 1912, n. ser., 38: 1313.— Walther. C. Resultat fonctionnel d'une reparation du tendon extenseur avec diformite de l'annulaire par cal angulaire de la premiere phalange. Ibid., 1916, 42: 671-3.—Wilmoth, C. L. Tendinoplasty of the flexor tendons of the hand; use of tunica vaginalis in reconstructing tendon sheaths. J. Bone Surg., 1937, 19: 152-6. --- Tumor. See also subheadings Cancer; Chondroma; Cyst; Lipoma; Sarcoma. Black, W. C. Synovioma of the hand; report of a case. Am. J. Cancer, 1936, 28: 481-4.—Eckhoff, N. Tumours and swellings of the hand. Guy's Hosp. Gaz., Lond., 1937, 51: 199-204.—Kyle. B. H. Ossifying fibroma, thenar space. Vir- ginia M. Month., 1941, 68: 165.—Mason, M. L. Tumors of the hand. Surg. Gyn. Obst., 1937, 64: 129-48.------& Woolston, W. H. Isolated giant cell xanthomatic tumors of the fingers and hand. Arch. Surg., 1927, 15: 499-529.—Ma- ther, J. H. A calcified fibroma of the hand. Brit. J. Radiol., B. I. R. Sect., 1927, 32: 251.—Perera. Manos de un individuo de 56 anos, afecto de papilomas corneos multiples. Progr. elfn., Madr., 1916, 7: 300.—Rizzacasa, N. Sulla struttura di un tumoretto pendulo del mignolo di un neonato. Atti Soc. ital. ostet., 1928, 27: 639-45— Schreiner. B. F.. & Wehr, W. H. Primary new growths involving the hand. Am. J. Roentg., 1934, 32: 516-23.—Simard. L. C. Tumour of the palm having the structure of a mixed tumour of the sal- ivary glands. Am. J. Cancer, 1938, 33: 182-95. HAND and foot. See also Finger and toe; Foot; Hand. Anseroff, N. J. Die Arterien des Skelets der Hand und des Fusses des Menschen. Zschr. Anat. Entw., 1936, 106: 193- 208.—Giraudi, G. I punti d'ossificazione (cosidette pseudo- epifisi) della troclea, delle falangi, del capitello dei primi e della base dei quattro ultimi metacarpali e metatarsali. Radiol. med., Milano, 1934, 21: 203-24.—Haefner, R. The relation between hand and foot tendencies of children. J. Genet. Psychol., 1930, 38: 338-51.—Hasebe, K. Ueber das Haut- leistensystem der Vola und Planta der Japaner und Aino. Arb. Anat. Inst. Univ. Sendai, 1918, H. 1, 13-88, 7 pl.— Joly, N., & Lavocat, A. Etude d'anatomie philosophique sur la main et le pied de l'homme et sur les extremites des mamrni- feres, ramenes au type pentadaetyle. J. med. vet., Lyon, 1853, 9: 229-36.—Kahn, M. An X-ray and clinical study of the bones of the hands and feet. Radiology, 1931, 16: 211-5.— Koch, K. Das Verhalten der Arterienbogen in der Vola manus und Planta pedis bei Affen. Zschr. Anat. Entw., 1939-40, 110: 81-97.—Kuriki, S. Quantitative Untersuchung dot Schweissdriise der Handteller- und Fussohlenhaut bei einem Affen. Okajimas fol. anat., 1937, 15: Ergsinzbd., 129-43.— Lange, Cornelia de [Hands and feet] Mschr. kindergeneesk., 1935, 4: 353-63, 13 pl.—Latarjet, A., & Etienne-Martin, M. L'appareil de glissement des tendons extenseurs des doigts et des orteils sur le dos de la main et sur le dos du pied. Ann. anat. path., Par., 1932, 9: 604-10.—Midlo, C. Form of hand and foot in primates. Am. J. Phys. Anthrop., 1934, 19: 337-89.—Posener, K., Walker, E., & Weddell, G. Radiographic studies of the metacarpal and metatarsal bones in children. J. Anat., Lond., 1939-40, 74: 76-9, pl.—Tani- guchi, T., & Kuriki, S. Quantitative Untersuchung der Schweissdriise der Handteller- und der Fussohlenhaut bei den Japanern. Okajimas fol. anat., 1937, 15: Erganzbd., 145-93.— Thews, K. Fehldeutung und -behandlung auf Grund von Varietiiten der Handwurzel und Fusswurzel im Rontgenbilde. Rontgenpraxis, 1939; 11: 184-6.—Thuringer, J. M. The mitotic index of the palmar and plantar epidermis in response to stimulation. J. Invest. Derm., 1939, 2: 313-26. ---- Abnormity. Boy [H. G.] A. *Weitercr Bei (rag zur Frage der angeborenen Missbildungen an Handen und Fiissen. 23p. 21cm. Konigsb., 1938. Brunet, P. *Quelques cas de malformations . congenitales de la main et du pied [Lausanne] 31 p. 8° Strasb., 1930. Also Arch, anat., Strasb., 1931-32, 13: 1-31. Hofmann, M. *VererbungvonSpalthand und Spaltfuss; Beobachtungen an 2 Familien [Miin- chen] 31p. 8? Speyer, 1936. Kosteu, H. *Zur Frage der Zahn- und Haaranomalien bei syndaktyler Spalthand- und Spaltfussbildung. 16p. 8? Gott., 1936. Pikes de Lima, J. A. As anomalias dos mem- bros nos Portugueses. 177p. 8? Porto, 1927. Quenzel, P. *Beitrag zu den Missbildungen an Hand und Fuss (Strahlcndefekt, Spalthand, Spaltfuss, Svndaktvlie, Hvperphalangie des Dau- tnens) 20p. 8? Halle (Salle) 1932. Agro, G. Contributo alio studio delle malformazioni con- genite a carattere familiare (piede torto e mano torta) Cult. med. mod., Pal., 1931, 10: 930-6.—Ballmann, E. Ueber Akromikrie (Brugsch) Zschr. ges. Anat., 2. Abt., 1927, 13: 241-51.—Behr, F. Ueber eine symmetrische Synostose der Hand- und Fusswurzelknochen. Arch, orthop." UnfaUchir., 1932-33, 32: 12-5.—Bergonzi, M. Contributo alio studio dell'acromicria. Riv. pat. nerv., 1936, 47: 125-45.—Bouet, O. Symmetrische Brachvdactvlie und Hvpophalangie in Hand und Fuss. Acta radiol., Stockh., 1934, 15: 24-7, pl.—Braun, K. Ueber eine offenbar typische Kombination von angeborenen Abweichungen des Hand- und Fusskeletes. Zschr. menschl. Vererb., 1939, 23: 510-5.—Brugsch. Leber Akromikrie. Klin. Wschr., 1927, 6: 185.—Catalano, F. E. Malformacion de manos y pies. Prensa med. argent., 1940, 27: 1081.— Cooperman, M. B. An unusual congenital deformity of the hand combined with supernumerary toes; a case report. J. Bone Surg., 1930, 12: 956—Decourt, J., & Trotol, R. Aero- micrie. Bull. Soc. med. hop. Paris, 1936, 3. ser., 52: 928-33.— Desnoyers, R. Malformations multiples des mains et des pieds. Rev. orthop., Par., 1925, 3. ser., 12: 47-55.—Egiies, A., & Fernandez, J. C. Deformaciones consenitas de las manos y de los pies; anomalia hereditaria v familiar. Bol. Inst. clin. quir., B. Air., 1938, 14: 335-41.—Forster, A. La pince pal- maire et la pince plantaire de Perodicticus potto; etude d'adap- tation squelettique et musculaire. Arch, anat., Strasb., 1934-35, 17: 181-246.—Hegdekatti, R. M. Congenital mal- formation of hands and feet in man. J. Hered., 1939, 30: 191-6.—Jansen, M. Klauenhand und Klauenfuss. Zschr. orthop. Chir., 1932-33, 58: 193-9.—Karsch, J. Erbliche Augenmissbildung in Verbindung mit Spalthand und -fuss. Zschr. Augenh., 1936, 89: 274-9.—Kellner, A. W. Ueber Spalthand und -fuss mit Oligodaktylie. Klin. Wschr., 1934, 13: 1507-9— Kemp, T., & Ravn, J. Ueber erbliche Hand- und Fussdeformitaten in einem 140-kopfigen Geschlecht, nebst einigen Bemerkungen uber Poly- und Svndaktylie beim Menschen. Acta psychiat. neur., Kbh., 1932, 7: 275-96, 7 pl., ch.—Kewesch, E. L. Ueber hereditare Versehmelzung der Hand- und Fusswurzelknochen. Fortsch. Roentgenstrahl., 1934, 50: 550-6.—Klages, F., & Jacob, R. Anatomische und erbbiologische Untersuchungen an einer mit Spaltftissen und Missbildungen der Hande behafteten Sippe. Zschr. Orthop., 1939-40, 70: 265-81.—Koehler, O. Die hand- und fusslosen brasilianischen Geschwister; ein Beitrag zur Frage der Erbbe- dingtheit angeborener Missbildungen. Zschr. menschl. Vererb., 1936, 19: 670-90.—Koenner, D. M. Abnormalities of the hands and feet. J. Hered., 1934, 25: 329-34— Lange, M. Storungen der Strahlenanlagen an den Gliedmassen. Arch. Kinderh., 1940, Beih. 21, 18.—Liceaga, F. J. Un nuevo caso de malformacion congenita de manos y pies. Sem. med., B. Air., 1936, 43: 421-5.------Un cas de syndactylie complete des mains et des pieds, et autres malformations., Bull. Soc. pediat. Paris, 1937, 35: 141-6.—Liebenam, L. Beitrag zum familiaren Vorkommen von Spalthiinden und Spaltftissen. Zschr. menschl. Vererb., 1938-39, 22: 136-51.— MacArthur, J. W., & McClulough, E. Apical dystrophy an inherited defect of hands and feet. Human Biol., 1932, 4: 179-207.—Markalous, E. ITwo cases of rare abnormities: brachymetapodia, status dysraphicus Bremen] Cas. 16k. cesk.,' 1935, 74: 408-13.—Mestern, J. Erbliche Synostosen der Hand- und Fusswurzelknochen; erbliches Os tibia le ex- ternum. Rontgenpraxis, 1934, 6: 594-600.—Moniz, E. Acromicrie. Rev. neur., Par., 1925, 32: 1014-27.—Muyle, G., & Batselaere, R. Contribution a l'etude du syndrome denomme mains et pieds en fourche. J. beige neur. psychiat., 1936, 36: 441-55.—Otte, P. Malformations congenitales. J. radiol. electr., 1928, 12: 507.—Peacock, W. Hereditary absence of hands and feet. Eugen. News, 1929, 14: 46, ill.— Perez, M. L., & Abdala, J. R. Polidactilia transitoria, Pires de Lima, dedos pediculados supernumeraries, H. Cummins, o dedos supernumerarios aberrantes, Ombredanne. Rev. HAND AND FOOT 72 HAND AND FOOT med., B. Air., 1939, 1: 1-1<> Politzer, G. Ueber Missbil- dungen des Hand- und Fusskelettes und uber ihre formale Conese. Fortsch. Rontgenstrahl.. 1931, 43: 605-19.—Rocher, H. L. Mains botes palmaire^ et pieds bots equins cavus par d\ ~i>laaies musculaires congenitales. Bordeaux chir., 1930, I: :; 12 -5.—Rosenstern, I. Ueber einen Fall von Akromikrie mi kmdesalter. Endokrinologie, 192S, 2: 269-77.—Savin, I.. IL. A. Sorsby, A. Two brothers, members of a family with lobster-claw (split-hand and split-foot deformity) one showing the skeletal deformity and the other aniridia. Proc. IL Soc. M., Lond., 1934-35, 28: 525.—Schachter-Nancy. M. Etude sur l'acromicrie fanuliale, cas personnels. Rev. fr. endocr., 1937, 15: 208-15.—Semenskaia, E. [Case of acromicria] Klin, med., Moskva, 1927, 5: 1335-7.—Seroiczkowski, A. Symmetrische Missbildung an beiden Hiinden und Fiissen <>p:dtbildung) Zschr. ges. Anat., 1. Abt,, 1929, 89: 145-55.— Stephan. Poly- und Syndaktylie in Beziehung zum Gesetz zur Verhiitung erbkranken Nachwuchses. Mschr. Geburtsh. Gyn., 1934-35,98: 253.—Stephens, B. P. Cleft feet and hands; an operation devised to permit use of ordinary shoes and a study of the etiology. Proc. Congr. Panpacific Surg. Ass., 1939, 330-4, pl.—Stiles, K. A. The inheritance of brachy- metapody. J. Hered., 1939, 30: 87-91.—Stroer, W. F. Fami- liares Auftreten von Hand- und Fussabweichungen in fiinf Generationen. Genetica, Gravenh., 1935. 17: 299-312, [Certain peripheral malformations] Xed. tschr. geneesk., 1935, 79: 373- Subrahmanyam, S. A case of deformity of the bone.-, of the hand and feet of a mother transmitted to her child. Ind. M. Gaz., 1934, 69: 633.^Tescola. C. Anomalie scheletrii he congenite rare delle mani e dei piedi nello stesso soggetto. Riv. radiol., 1931, 5: 570-6.—Zuppa. A. Considera- zioni su alcuni casi di malformazioni congenite delle mani e dei piedi. Pediatria (Riv.) 1934, 42: 943-66. ---- Disease, and tumor. Kinzel, H. *Dupuytrensche Kontraktur an Hand und Fuss. 14p. 8? Bresl., 1927. Pack, G. T., ed. Tumors of the hands and feet. 138p. 26cm. S. Louis, 1939. Andrews, G. C. A case for diagnosis (pustular eruption of the palms and soles) Arch. Derm. Syph., Chic, 1934, 29: 741. ------& Machacek, G. F. Pustular bacterids of the hands and feet. Ibid.. 1935, 32: 837 47— Auvray. Double retrac- tion de I'a pone v lose palmaire et de l'aponevrose plantain: chez le ineine sujet. Bull. Soc. nat. chir., Par., 1929, 55: 1026.- Ballagi. S. Ueber Hand- und Fussmykosen mit be- sonderer Beriicksichtigung der mvkotischen D\ shidrose. Med. Klin.. Beil.. 1935. 31: 1204.—Briinschwig. A. Tumors of the s\ novia, tendons, and joint capsules of the hands and feet, Surgery, 1939, 5: 101-11.—Cokkalis, P. Dupuytrensche Kontraktur der Palmar- und Plantaraponeurose. Deut. Zschr. Chir., 1925-26, 194: 256-8.—Coley, B. L., & Higin- botham, N. L. Tumors primary in the bones of the hands and feet. Surgery, 1939, 5: 112-28.- Ebert, M. H. Recalcitrant eruption of palms and soles. Bull. Chicago M. Soc, 1935, 38: 274.— Gerencser, N. [Data on epidemiology of mycosis of hand and foot] Orv. hetil., 1937, 81: 576-8—Giordano, D. Cancro del piede in donna, della mano in uomo, die e anehe varicoso. Cazz. internaz. med. chir., 1934, 42: 403-9.— Hall. T. R. Enlarging conceptions of mycotic infections of the feet and hands. .1. Missouri M. Ass., 1934, 31: 50-4.—Hard- wick, C. A tvpe of osseous dystrophy affecting the hands and feet. Proc. R. Soc. M., Lond., 1937-38, 31: 1167.—Huguet, J., & Arnaud. M. Quelques osteopathies des mains et des pieds difficiles a 6tiqueter. Bull. Soc. eiectroradiol. med. France, 1938, 26: 70-3.—Josselin de Jong, R. de [Tropho- neurotic atrophy of the bones of the feet and hands] Ned. tschr. geneesk., 1934, 78: 1720-7. 2 pl— Kahn, M., & Cohn, L. C. Diagnosis and treatment of bone lesions of the hand and foot, with special reference to bone tumors. Radiology, 1927, 8: 289-91.—Kennedy, C. B. Common vesicular lesions of the hands and feet; diagnosis and treatment. South. M. J., 1940, 33: 1036-9.—Love, R. J. M. Some miner surgical condi- tions of the hands and feet. Practitioner, Lond., 1939, 142: 261-9.—MacCormac, H. Skin diseases of the hands and feet. Ibid., 249-60.—Mason, M. L. Carcinoma of the hands and feet. Surgery, 1939, 5: 27-46.—Matolcsy, T. von. Ueber die Geschwulste der kleinen Knochen an Hiinden und Fiissen Arch. klin. Chir., 1934, 179: 708-16.—Mitchell, J. H. Strep- tococcic infection simulating ringworm of the hands and feet J. Am. M. Ass., 1935, 104: 1220-5.—Morginson, W. J. Derma- tophytosis of the feet, hands and groins. Illinois M. J 1936 70: 371-6. Oughterson, A. W.f & Tennant. R. Angiomatous tumors of the hands and feet. Surgery, 1939, 5: 73-100.__ Pack. G. T. Symposium; tumors of the hands and feet Ibid. 1-26.—Percival, G. H. Fungus infection of the hands and feet. Edinburgh M. J., 1937, 44: 401-9.—Pillsbury, D. M., & Livingood, C. Chronic pyogenic dermatitis of the hand- and feet with bacterid on the arms and trunk. Arch Derm. Syph., Chic, 1940, 42: 741.—Ravogli, A. Considera- tions sur quelques eruptions des paumes des mains et des plantes des pieds d'origine vasomotrice. P. verb Congr derm. syph. fr. (1923) 1925, 2. congr., 650-9, 6 pl.—Rouillard; J.. & Scnwob. R. A. Retraction des apon6vroses palmaires et plantaires; coexistence de gros troubles sensitifs du tvpe svringo- myehque. Bull. Soc. mid. hdp. Paris, 1931, 3. ser 47-712-7 — Ruiter, M. [Case of intractable pustular affection'of palms and soles] Ned. tschr. geneesk., 1937, 81: I" *:i. I'l.— Sams, W. M. Fungous infections of the hands and feet. J. Florida M. Ass., 1935-36, 22: 360-3.—Schmidt. P. W. Zur Pathogenese der Epidermophytien und Tiicliophytien der Hande und 1'iisse unter besonderer Berucksichtigung der ekzematoiden llautveranderungen mit Kulturergcbnissen von 732 Fallen. Arch. Derm. Syph., Berl., 1933, 169: 259-94.— Schonberg, I. L. A case for diagnosis. Arch. Derm. Syph., Chic, 1939, 40: 846.—Showman, W. A. Vesicular eruptions of the hands and feet. J. Oklahoma IM. Ass., 1934,27:284-7 — Stein, R. O. The mycotic eczema of the palms of the hands and of the soles of the feet and its treatment. Ind. J. Vener. Dis., 1937, 3: 19-25.—Strickler, A., Ozellers, E. A., & Zaletel, R. P. Modern interpretation of mycotic infections of the feet and hands. Arch. Derm. Syph., Chic, 1932, 25: 1028-40. Also repr.—Tinea of hands and feet, dermatophytosis. J. Pediat., S. Louis, 1938, 12: 827.—Valdoni, P. Lipoma ar- borescente sistemico delle guaine tendinee della mano e del piede. Chir. org. movim., 1930-31, 15: 509-29.—West, C. O. Common vesicular eruptions of the hands and feet. J. Kansas M. Soc, 1933, 34: 43-7. ---- Fracture, and injury. Christoffersen, A. K. [Modification in extension treatment in fractures of the fingers, metacarpus, and metatarsus] Ugeskr. laeger, 1933, 95: 1239-40. Deubncr. Der elastische Drahtzug an Fingern und Zehen. Arch, orthop. UnfaUchir., 1933-34, 34: 709.—Gerin, C. La diagnosi radiologica di eta delle fratture dei metatarsi, dei metaearpi e delle falangi. Arch. antrop. crim., Tor., 1937, 57: Suppl., 385-7. ■------ Studio infortunistico sugli esiti delle fratture dei metatarsi e dei metaearpi. Ibid., 387-9.—Goldblatt. D. Removal of foreign bodies from hands, fingers and feet. Am. J. Surg., 1930, n. ser., 8: 324-7.—Haggart, G. E. Fractures of the metacarpal, metatarsal bones and phalanges treated by skeletal traction. Surg. Clin. N. America, 1934, 14: 1203-10.—Jacobson, S. A. [Symptom in fractures of metatarsal and metacarpal bones] Khirurgia, Moskva, 1937, No. 3, 114-6.—Lohr, W. Die Behandlung von frischen und iilteren Hand- und Fussverlet- zungenmitSubstanzverlustenmit dem Lebertran-Gipsverband. Chirurg, 1934, 6: 5-11.—Masland, H. C. Implements for foot and hand injuries. Am. J. Surg., 1931, n. ser., 12: 142.— Rider, D. L. Fractures of the metacarpals, metatarsals, and phalanges. Ibid., 1937, 38: 549-59.—Schmorell, H. Die chirurgische Behandlung der Hand- und Fingerverletzungen (mit Ausnahme der Knochenbruche) Med. Klin., Berl., 1933, 29: 1382; 1414; 1449.—Sprunck. Ueber Fremdkorperverlet- zungen an Hiinden und Fiissen und deren Behandlung durch den Truppenarzt. Deut. Militararzt, 1939, 4: 490-2. HAND-BOOK for hospitals. 263p. 8? N. Y., G. P. Putnam's sons, 1883. HANDBOOK of tuberculosis schemes; v.l. England and Wales. 2. ed. 164p. 8? Lond., Aclard & son & West Newman, 1919. HANDBUCH ... See also under the name of the editor. HANDBUCH der biologischen Arbeitsmetho- den; hrsg. von Emil Abderhalden. Berl., Abt. 1, Teil 1, 1920- HANDBUCH fiir Dentisten; hrsg. von Lehr- korper des Lehrinstituts fiir Dentisten, Karlsruhe i. B. 2. Aufl. 3v. illust. pl. 8? Munch., Reichsverbd Deut. Dentisten, 1935. HANDBUCH der Neurologie; hrsg. von Oswald Bumke und Otfrid Foerster. Berl., 18v., 1935-37. HANDBUCH der Ohrenheilkunde. See Marx, Herman. Kurzes Handbuch der Ohrenheil- kunde. 846p. 25j^cm. Jena, 1938. HANDBUCH der zahnarztlichen Rechtskunde [&c] See Meier, L. HANDBUECHEREI fiir den dffentlichen Ge- sundheitsdienst; hrsg. von A. und Giitt und E. Moebius. 9v. 8? Berl., C. Heymann, 1935-38. CONTENTS Bd 1. Oeffentliche Gesundheitsdienst. A. Giitt & E. Moebius. 1935. Bd la. Oeffentliche Gesundheitsdienst. Textausgabe des Gesetzes uber die Vereinheitlichung des Gesundheitswesens vom 3. Juli 1934. A. Giitt. 1935. ... ?d ?■ Grundlagen der Erb- und Rassenpflege. E. Burg- dorfer [et al.] 1936. Bd 3. Der Arzt (M. Bauer, Cropp, Walther) 1938. Bd 5. Apothekenwesen. W. Kahler. 1937. •l £dJJ- ^ettungs- und Krankenbeforderungswesen. E. Hesse & if. Bruckmeyer. 1937. Bd 9. Lebensmittelverkehr. Barnes & Ertel. 1937. Bd 6. Ortshygiene [und] Bader und Kurorte. H. Lehmann HANDBUECHEREI 73 HANDEDNESS & H. Vogt. 1936. , x . , ,. L Bd 15. Gerichtliche Medizin (F. Pietrusky); genchthche Psychiatrie (M. de Crinis) 1938. HANDCOCK, William, 1866-1929. Obituary. Brit. M. J., 1929, 1: 1021. HANDEDNESS. See also Ambidexterity; Laterality; Skill; Symmetry. Alsbehg, M. Rechtshandigkeit und Links- handigkeit, sowie deren mutmassliche Ursachen. 32p. 8? Hamb., 1894. Durost, W. N. The development of a battery of objective group tests of manual laterality, with the results of their application to 1300 children. 335p. 8? Worcester, 1934. Heinlein, J. H. Preferential manipulation in children. 121p. 8? Bait., 1930. Kobler, R. Der Weg des Menschen vom Links- zum Rechtshander; ein Beitrag zur Vor- und Kulturgeschichte des Menschen. 142p. 8? Wien, 1932. Koch, H. L. A study of the nature, measure- ment, and determination of hand preference. p.l 17-221. 8? Worcester, 1933. Ludwig, W. Das Rechts-Links-Problem im Tierreich und beim Menschen; mit einem Anhang: Rechts-Links-Merkmale der Pflanzen. 496p. 8? Berl., 1932. Wile, I. S. Handedness, right and left. 439p. 8? Bost., 1934. Audenino. E. Mancinismo e destrismo. Arch, psichiat., Tor., 1908, 29: 292-301.—Bethe, A. Rechtshandigkeit und Linkshandigkeit vom Stand punkt der Plastizitatslehre. Sunti Congr. internaz. fisiol., 1932, 14. Congr., 32. —---- Ist der Rechtshander dem Linkshander iiberlegen? Umschau, 1933, 37: 973.—Bettmann, S. Die Papillarleistenzeichnung der Handflache in ihrer Beziehung zur Hiindigkeit. Zschr. ges. Anat., 1. Abt., 1932, 98: 649-74.—Bordas, S. Ergo- metrographische Untersuchungen der Arbeitsleistung von Rechts- und Linkshandern. Arbeitsphysiologie, 1935-37, 9: 550-61.—Brann, R. Untersuchungen zur Frage der Rechts- und Linkshandigkeit und zum Gestalterkennen aus der Be- wegung bei Kindern. Arch. Psychiat., Berl., 1928-29, 86: 255-71.—Burger, H. Rechts und links. Nervenarzt, 1929, 2: 464-72.—Castner, B. M. Handedness and eyedness of children referred to a guidance clinic. Psychol. Rec, 1939, 3: 99-112.—^ Chesher, E. C. Some observations concerning the relation of handedness to the language mechanism. Bull. Neur. Inst. N York 1935-36,4:556-62.—Crichton-Browne, J. Dexterity and the'bend sinister. Proc. R. Inst. Gr. Britain (1905-7) 1909, 18: Notices 623-52, 11 pl.—Cuff, N. B. The interpreta- tion of handedness. J. Exp. Psychol., 1928, 11: 27-39-—-— A study of eyedness and handedness. Ibid., 1931,14: 164-75.— Cummins, H. Fingerprints correlated with handedness. Verh. Anat. Ges., 1937, 44: 87. Also Am. J. Phys. Anthrop., 1940 26: 151-66.—Downey, J. E. Distinguishing right from left.' Pedag. Semin., Worcester, 1926, 33: 153-66——— Types of dextrality and their implications. Am. J. Psychcl 1927, 38: 317-67. ------ Some curious problems suggested by case-studies of handedness. J. Abnorm. Psychol., 1932, 27: 152-8 —Elze, C. Kann jedermann rechts und links unter- scheiden? Deut. Zschr. Nervenh., 1926, 90: 146-51.—Esser, A. A. M. Aeugigkeit und Hiindigkeit. Klin. Mbl. Augenh., 1927, 78: 332-8.—Freeman, G. L., & Chapman, J. S. The relative importance of eye and hand dominance in a pursuit of skill. Amer. J. Psychol., 1935, 47: 146-9.—Gordon, A. Family stock betterment, with reference to left-handedness. Med. Times, N. Y., 1932, 60: 243.— Gould. G.M. The origin of right-handedness. Boston M. & S. J., 1907,, 157:[597-601. Also repr.------Why is a particular_child right-handed or left-handed? Long Island M. J., 1907 1: 454-8. The rule of the road. Popular Sc. Month., 1908, 52-64. ------ Righthandedness and lefthandedness. Dietet. Hyg. Gaz 1910, 26: 139-44.—Haack, T. Das Rechts-Lmks- Problem und die Bewegungsrichtungen der bildenden Kunst. Zschr. angew. Psychol., 1938, 54: 32-9.—Hartshorne J. Righthandedness and lefthandedness. Albany M. Ann 1911, 32- 338-44.—Heinlein, J. H. A study of dextrality in children. J. Genet. Psychol., 1929, 36: 91-119.—Hertz, R. La pre- eminence de 'la main droite; etude sur la polante rehgieuse. Rev nhilos , Par., 1909, 68: 553-80.—Huber. J. B. Why are we righihanded? Sc American, 1910, 102: 260;; 26&- Ingalls, N. W. On righthandedness. Sc. Month., 1928, £». 307-21 —Johnson, W., & Duke, D. Revised Iowa hand usage dextrality quotients of six-year-olds. J. Educ. Psychol., 1940 31: 45-52.—Jones, E. An attempt to define the terms used'in connection with right-handedness. Psychol. Bull., 1909 6- 130-2 ------ Right-handedness and allied topics. Ibid' 1910 7-377.—Jones, H. E. Dextrality as a function of age. J. Exp. Psychol., 1931, 14: 125-43.—Jousse, M. Le bilateralisme humain et l'anthropologie du langage. Rev. anthrop., Par., 1940, 50: 141-70.—Keller, R. Acerca do problema da heterolateralidade na arte. Actas Ciba, Rio, 1940, 7: 57-60.—Klein, R. Beitrag zur Frage der Beziehungen von Rechts- beziehungsweise Linkshandigkeit und dem funk- tionellen Ueberwiegen einer Hemisphiire. Med. Klin., Berl., 1933, 29: 1367.—Korngold, S. Contribution k l'etude de la dextrality. C. rend. Conf. internat. psychotechn. (1934) 1935, 8. Conf., 115-25.—Kraskin, L. H. A study of factors entering into the determination of handedness. Tr. Am. Acad. Optometry, 1933, 8: 26-31.—Leche, S. M. Handedness and bimanual dennatoglyphic differences. Am. J. Anat., 1933, 53: 1-53.—Ledenyi, J. [Right-handedness] Bratisl. lek. listy, 1934, 14: 58-73.—Liepmann, H. Bemerkungen zu Rich. Arw. Pfeifers Aufsatz: Beobachtungen an Rechts- und Linkshiinderschrift von anschein weittragender Bedeutung. Zschr. ges. Neur. Psychiat., 1921, 68: Orig., 376-83 — Livi, R. Sulla causa del destrismo e del mancinismo. Atti Soc. rom. anthrop., Roma, 1908, 14: 92-4.—Ludwig, W. Analogien zwischen Bestimmung des Geschlechtes und Be- stimmung der Asymmetrieform (Rechts-Links-Problem) Biol. Zbl., 1935, 55: 250-67.—Maki, N. Natiirliche Bewegungs- tendenzen der rechten und der linken Hand und ihr Einfluss auf das Zeichnen und den Erkcnnungsvorgang. Psychol. Forsch., 1928, 10: 1-19.—Mendel, K. Ueber Rechtshirnigkeit bei Rechtshandern. Berl. klin. Wschr., 1912, 49: 806 — Meyer, R. Die Koppelung von Augenmass und Handigkeit. Arch. ges. Psychol., 1937, 98: 135-42.—Minor, L. Ueber die Dorsalvenen der Hande in ihren Beziehungen zur Rechts- und Linkshandigkeit. Deut. Zschr. Nervenh., 1932, 126: 1-18.— Mousson-Lanauze. Main droite et main gauche. Paris med., 1926, 62: annexe, 161.—Newman, H. H. Dermato- glyphics and the problem of handedness. Am. J. Anat., 1934, 55: 277-322.—Offringa, R. P. [Lefthanded dentists] Tschr. tandheelk., 1933, 40: 127.—Pacini, F. Della causa prima da cui procede la destrezza del braccio diritto e della gamba diritta. Gazz. toscana sc. med. fis., 1850, 8: 361-6.—Peterson, G. M. A preliminary report on right and left handedness in the rat. J. Comp. Psychol., 1931, 12: 243-50.----— The influence of ligating one of the common carotid arteries upon handedness in the rat. Ibid., 1932, 14: 1-3, pl. ■------ The influence of cerebral destructions upon the handedness of the rat in the latch box. Ibid., 1938, 26: 445-57, pl. ------ & Fracarol, La C. The relative influence of the locus and mass of destruction upon the control of handedness by the cerebral cortex. J. Comp. Neur., 1937-38, 68: 173-90.—Pfeifer, R. A. Vorlaufige Erwiderung zu Liepmanns Kritik meiner Arbeit: Beobachtungen an Rechts- und Linkshiinderschrift von anscheinend weittragender Bedeutung. Zschr. ges. Neur. Psychiat., 68: 416. ------ Bemerkungen zur Links- und Rechtshandigkeit. Deut. med. Wschr., 1927, 53: 861. Also Med. Klin., Berl., 1927, 23: 623. Also Munch, med. Wschr., 1927, 74: 346.—Piedelievre, Derobert & Fourault. Gauchers et droitiers. Ann. med. leg., 1934, 14: 915-22.—Pomme, B., & Pechoux, R. Etude de la courbe oscillometrique des membres supfirieurs chez les gauchers. Ibid., 1935, 15: 820-5.—Quinan, C. Involuntary graphic sprawl; a motor phenomenon related to mirror-writing and modified by the factor of handedness. Arch. Neur. Psychiat., Chic, 1935, 34: 318-29.------ Can the brainedness factor right or left be established by graphic time data alone? J. Exp. Psychol., 1937, 21: 230-5 — Raney, E. T. Brain potentials and lateral dominance in identical twins. Ibid., 1939, 24: 21-39— Rife, D. C. Handed- ness of twins. Science, 1939, 89: 178. ------• Handedness, with special reference to twins. Genetics, 1940, 25: 178-86.— Right and left handedness. Lancet, Lond., 1909, 1: 1340.— Right-handed rats made southpaws by brain lesions. Science N. Lett., 1934, 25: 315.—Roos, M. M. B. A study of factors entering into the determination of handedness. Bull. George Washington Univ., 1932-34, Summaries 42-6, 1934. ------ Variations with age in frequency distributions of degrees of handedness. Child Develop., 1935, 6: 259-68.—Rule (The) of the road. Brit. M. J., 1912, 2: 991.—Schiller, A. Theories of handedness. J. Appl. Psychol., 1935, 19: 694-703 — Schiller, M. Probleme um die Linkshandigkeit mit Unter- suchungen an Stuttgarter Schulkindem. Zschr. ges. Neur. Psychiat., 1932, 140: 496-516.—Schott. Ueber rechts und links beim Menschen. Mschr. Psychiat. Neur., 1930, 77: 186-202. ------ Ueber Rechts- und Linkshandigkeit bei Geistesschwachen. Zschr. Behandl. Anomal., 1930, 50: 97-101. ------ Zum Problem der Linkshandigkeit. Zschr. angew. Psychol., 1932, 43: 119-23.—Shen, N. C. Handedness effect in simultaneous lifting of weights by both hands. J. Exp. Psychol., 1936, 19: 64-76.—Smith, F. O. An experi- mental study of the reaction time of the cerebral hemispheres in relation to handedness and eyedness. Ibid., 1938, 22: 75_g3 —Smith, J. M. The sensory function of the non- preferred hand. Ibid., 1933, 16: 271-82.—Smith, L. G. A brief survey of right- and left-handedness. Pedag. Semin., Worcester, 1917, 24: 19-35.—Smith, S. Right- and left- handedness. Psychol. Bull., 1916, 13: 429.—Stern H J. Ueber Vorherrschaft eines Auges (Aeugigkeit) und ihre Be- ziehung zur Handigkeit. Arch. ges. Physiol., 1933-34, 233: 793-807.—Tuttle, W. W., & Travis, L. E. The relation of precedence of movement in homologous structures to handed- ness. Res. Q. Am. Phys. Educ. Ass., 1935, 6: Suppl., 3-14.— Valsik. J. [Problem of right- and left-handedness in the light of epidermal configurations of the palm of the human hand] HANDEDNESS 74 HANDEDNESS Cas. lek. fe.sk., 1928, 67: 205-7- Voclckel, E. Untersu- chungen Uber die Rechtshandigkeit beim Saugling. Zschr. Kinderh., 1913, 8: Orig., 351-8.— Volkmann. Erziehungs- probleme bei Linkshiindern. Med. Klin., Berl., 1941, 37: 448-50.- Wentworth, K. L. The effect of early reaches on handedness in the rat; a preliminarv studv. J. Genet. Psvchol., 1938, 52: 429-32.—Wevill. L. B. The occipital bone and the bones of the superior extremity in relation to right or left handedness. Edinburgh 11. J.', 1928. n. ser., 35: 12-20.— Wiener. A. S. Observations on the manner of clasping the hands .....1 folding the arms. Am. Natur., 1932, 66: 365-70.— Wile. I. S. Hand pteference in primitive man. Am. J. Ortho- psychiat.. 1933, 3: 95 112.—Williams, L. L. B. Of left- handedness In his Minor med. mysteries, Lond., 1936, 17-24- Wilson. M. ()., & Dolan, L.' B. Handedness and ability. Am. J. I'syehol., 1931, 43: 261-8.- Wolff. VV. O rcsto direito e o esquerdo. Actas Ciba. Rio, 1940, 7: 54-6.— Woo, T. L. Dextrality and sinistrality of hand and eye; second memoir. Biometrika, Cambr., 1928, 20: 79-148. ------ & Pearson, K. Dextrality and sinistrality of hand and eye. Ibid., 1927-28, 19: 165-99, 2 ch.—Woolley, H. T. The development of right-handedness in a normal infant. Psvchol. Rev., 1909, 17: 37 4 L—Yoshioka, J. G. Handedness in rats. J. Genet. Psychol., 1930, 38: 471-4. ---- Left-handedness. Sec also Speech, Disorders; Stuttering. Adam, J. *Les gauchers en medecine legale. 130p. 8? Par., 1935. Haefner, R. *The educational significance of left-handedness [Columbia Univ.] 84p. 8? N. Y., 1929. Barreras y Fernandez, A. La zurderfa desde el punto de vista medico-legal. Yida nueva, Habana, 1935, 35: 1 ; 83, eh.— ftertelson. A. [Lefthandedness in Greenland] Hospitalsti- dende, 192S. 71: 1393-415.—Bouterwek, H. Rechts-Links- AhwMiidluiig in Hiindigkeit und seeliseher Artung; ein Beitrag zur Z\\ illingsforschung und zur frage der Linkshandigkeit. Zschi. men»ehl. Vererb., 1937 38. 21: 737-60.— Brisard, C. Comment reconnaitre ct indemniser un gaucher. Ann. med. leg., 1934, 14: 621-7.—Chamberlain, H. D. The inheritance of left-handedness. J. Hered., 1928, 19: 557-9.—Dubar, L. Qu'est-ee qu'un gaucher? Rev. path, comp., Par., 1939, 39: 318-22.- Friedmann, A. Zum Problem der Linkshandigkeit, insbesondere im /aisaiiimonhaiig mil der Slot tei frage. Mschr. I'syebial., 1937 38. 97: 257 79. Canter. It. Leber Links- hainligkeit bei Epileptischen und Schwachsinnigen. Allg. Zschi. Psychiat., 193.3. 101: 195-201. Hahn, G. Links- handige.-, Schreiben fiir Kriegsverletzte. Linsehau, 1940. 44: 631. Inman, W. S. Left-handedness. Lancet, Lond., 1935, 1: 347.—Jordan, H. E. Hereditary lefthandedness, with a note on twinning. J. Genet., Cambr.. 1914 15, 4: 67-81.— Julliard. C. La sinistrose. Kiuxelles med., 1930-31, 11: 690-7.- Komai. T., & Fukuoka. G. A study on the frequency of left-handedness and left-footedness among Japanese school children. Human Biol., 1934, 6: 33 42.—Kovarsky, V. La gauchetie; les troubles foncl iimnels d'origine psychogenique chez les gauchers contraries. Ann. m6d. ps\-ehol., Par., 1938, 96: pt 2, 545-62.------Faut-il reed in pier les gaueheis? ('. rend. Aead. sc, 1938, 207: 743 5. I.auterbach, C. E. Shall the left-handed child be transferred? .1. Genet I'syehol 1933, 43: 454-62— Ledent. L. La gauchene. Liege 'med 1934, 27: 1388-93— Locke, R. W. Some aspects of left handed- ness. Med. GIT., Lond., 1929, 42: 17.—Manunza, P. Cenni storici sul mancinismo e rilievi in riferimento all'eta protosarda. Arch, antrop. crim., Tor., 1936, 56: 316-35. Also Atti Soc. sc. med. natur. Cagliari, 1935, 37: 358-77.—Michaels, J. J., & Goodman. S. E. Left-handedness; intercorrelations with , enuresis and other related factors in so-called normal children Arch. Neur. Psychiat., Chic, 1935, 34: 758-63.—Peola, P. II mancinismo nei preistorici di Castelceriolo (Alessandria) levolversi del destrismo e l'influenza esercitatevi delle loco- mozione e dai mezzi di lavoro. Arch, antrop. crim., Tor., 1936. 56: 291-315.—Peri, A. La diagnosi di mancinismo nella pmtiea infortunis-tica. Ibid., Suppl., 468-538.— Popenoe, P. I Alt-handedness. Hyg"ia. Chic, 1938, 16: 893; 952.— Riese. l)as Gehirn des l.inkshanders. Deut. med. Wsehr., 1926, 52: 1627. ----- Das Hun des Linkshanders. Med' Klin.. Berl.. 1926. 22: 1546. Also Miinch. med. Wsehr.. 1920, 73: 1383.- Ripin. R. Berichte iiber Linkshiindigk.il. Internat' Zschr. Individpsychol., 1932, 10: 410-4.—Rothschild, k! The relation of Brora's centre to lefthandedness. Mi.I Press A: Circ. Lond.. 1931. 132: 113-4.— Schott. A. Linkshandigkeit und Erblichkeit. Zschr. ges. Neur. I's.vehiat., 1931, 135: 305-13. Slromberg. E. T.. & Stromberg. K. L. Left handed- ness as a factor influencing academic achievement. J. Social Psychol., 1938. 9: 335-4 1. - - Wehnore. R. G., & E labrooks, G. H. The relation of left-handedn< -- to ps\ elioneurotic iraiis. J. Educ. Psychol., 1929, 20: 628.- White. A. M., ^cm. Wiirzb., R. Mayr, 1938. HANGHOMIA. Thenint, A., & Ingii, A. Etude d'une plant du Laos, la liane parfum6e hang-hom, Hanghomia marselli, F. Gapnep et A. Thenint, sp. nov. Bull. sc. pharm., Par., 1936, 43: 545; 635. HANGING. See also Asphyxia; Capital punishment; Death, violent; Murder; Strangulation; Suicide. Duff, C. A handbook on hanging. 128p. 16? Lond [1928] Jones, F. W. The examination of the bodies of 100 men executed in Nubia in Roman times. 2p. 4? Lond., 1908. Theben, A. *Ueber atypisches Erhangen. 19p. 8? Munster, 1935. Bord, B. Les pendus dans l'histoire et dans l'art. Aesculape, Par., 1929, n. ser., 19: 73; 117.—Dervieux, F. Un cas de pendaison incomplete. Ann. mid. leg., 1935, 15: 763.— Hausser, G. Histoire de pendus. Presse med., 1940, 48: 1059.—Maupassant, G. de. Sonet a une dame en lui envoyant un morceau de la corde d'un pendu. Aesculape, Par., 1940, 30: 25.—Tatiev, K. I. [Importance of saving the noose intact in cases of hanging and strangulation] Sudeb. med. ekspertiza, 1928, 101. ---- accidental. Gros, A. J. *La pendaison accidentelle. 81p. 8? Par., 1935. Haberda, A. Tod durch Erhangen als unbeabsichtigter Ausgang eines Scherzes. Beitr. gerichtl. Med., 1929, 9: 30-3.— Hiibner. Selbstmord oder zufalliges Erhangen aus sexuellen Motiven? Aerztl. Sachvers. Ztg, 1927, 33: 134-6.—Weimann, W. Ein Fall zufalliger Erhangung aus sexuellen Motiven. Arch. Krim.. 1935. 97: 62. HANGING 77 HANGING ---- Forensic aspect. Meuthen, H. *Zur Frage der fremden Schuld bei Erhangten. 48p. 22J/2cm. Bonn, 1937. Berka, F. [Hanging—suicide or homicide?] Cas. 16k. 6esk., 1934, 73: 481-4.—Bohmer, K. Totung durch Erhangen. Deut. Zschr. gerichtl. Med., 1939-40, 32: 449-53.—Kipper, F. Mord durch Erhangen. Arch. Krim., 1926, 78: 213-28 — Klauer, H. Untersuchung von Strangwerkzeug und Aufhange- ort beim fraglichen Erhangungstod. Deut. Zschr. gerichtl. Med., 1932-33, 20: 375-85. ------ Kriminaltechnische Untersuchungen an zerschnittenen Stricken. Ibid., 1936, 26: 321-7.—Laves, W. Totung durch Erwurgen mit nachtrag- lichem Aufhiingen der Leiche zur Vortauschung eines Selbst- mordes. Ibid., 1929, 14: 275-83.—Neugebauer, W. Zur Frage Selbstmord oder Mord durch Erhangen. Ibid., 1937, 28: 111-31.—Orth, H. Gewaltsames Erhangen; kasuistischer Beitrag. Ibid., 1933, 22: 262-71.—Reuter. F. Totung durch Erwurgen mit nachtraglichem Aufhiingen der Leiche zur Vortauschung eines Selbstmordes. Ibid., 1929, 14: 449-54.— Rooks, G. Selbstmord durch Erhangen oder Mord mit darauf- folgendem Aufhangen der Leiche? Arch. Krim., 1935, 97: 104-8, 2 pl. ---- Pathological anatomy. Blum, H. *Die lokale makroskopische und mikroskopische Reaktion beim Erhangen [Halle- Wittenberg] 47p. 21cm. Bleicherode a. Harz, 1937. Grotschla, H. *Die eigentliche Todesursache beim Erhangungstode vom gerichtlichmedizini- schen Standpunkt. 20p. 8? Bresl., 1936. Muller-Hess, B. *Ein Beitrag zur Sympto- matologie des Erhangungstodes. 40p. 22J^cm. Berl., 1938. Schulz [G.] R. *Blutungen in den Hals- lymphknoten bei Erhangten [Halle-Wittenberg] 20p. 8? Bleicherode-H., 1936. Adamo, M. II solco da impiccamento e il suo significato medico-legale. Zacchia, 1939, 2. ser., 3: 63-71.—Berczeller, A., & Nowotny, K. Ueber Hirnerschiitterung und Zustands- bilder nach Erhangungsversuchen. Mitt. Grenzgeb. Med. Chir., 1935, 44: 100-18.—Bingel. A., & Hampel, E. Spattod nach Erhangen; Beitrag zur Klinik und Anatomie der Kreislauf- storungen im Gehirn. Zschr. ges. Neur. Psychiat., 1933-34, 149: 640-56.—Blum, H. Zur Frage der Unterscheidbarkeit vitaler und postmortaler Gewebsveranderungen am Beispiel der Strangfurchen beim Erhangungstod. Virchows Arch., 1937, 299: 754-66.—Bohmer, K. Ungewohnliche Langsrisse in der Art. carotis communis. Deut. Zschr. gerichtl. Med., 1927, 10: 175-81.—Doring, G. Zur Histopathologic des Gehirnes bei Spattod nach Erhangen und nach Carotisunterbindung. Vir- chows Arch., 1935-36, 296: 666-80.—Gerhartz, H. Gehirn- schadigung beim Erhangen. Deut. Zschr. Nervenh., 1932, 128: 109-17.—Hultkvist, G. Druck der Strangulationsschlinge. Deut. Zschr. gerichtl. Med., 1929, 14: 214-28 — Jankovich. L., & Incze, J. Blutungen in den Lymphknoten des Halses beim Erhangungstod. Ibid., 1932-33, 20: 122-33.—Kalle, E. Beobachtungen iiber den Tod bei Hinrichtungen mit dem Strang. Ibid., 1933, 22: 192-203.—Leitner. Spattod nach Erhangen. Med. Welt. 1934, 8: 875.—Lyon-Caen. L. Frac- tures de cotes et contusion pulmonaire produites au cours d'une pendaison. Ann. mid. leg., 1926, 6: 271-3.—Martin, E. Mecanisme de la compression des carotides dans la pendaison. Ibid., 1930, 10: 565-7.—Nakata, T. Ein Beitrag zum Studium des Todes durch Erhangen. Jap. J. M. Sc, 1939-40, 3: Proc. Soc. Med. Hyg., 178-80.—Orsos, F. [Necrobiotic reaction of hanging and strangling] Orv. hetil, 1933, 77: 233-6.—Ponsold, A. Ohrenbluten beim Erhangen. Deut. Zschr. gerichtl. Med., 1937-38, 29: 437-42.—Schwarzacher, W. Beitrage zum Mechanismus des Erhangungstodes. Ibid., 1927-28, 11: 145- 53.—Slepyshkov, I. V. [Contents of the stomach found in respiratory tract in cases of death from hanging and suffoca- tion] Sudeb. med. ekspertiza, 1928, 44-7—Walcher, K. Medizinische und kriminalistische Untersuchungen beim Tode durch Erhangen, Erdrosseln, Erwurgen. In Handb. biol. Arbeitsmeth. (Abderhalden) Berl., 1934, 677-94.----— Beitrag zum lokalen ausseren Befund bei Erhangen. Deut. Zschr. gerichtl. Med., 1935, 25: 141-6. ------ Beitrag zum anato- mischen Befund bei Erhangten. Miinch. med. Wschr., 1935, 82: 1273-5.—Wolff, R. Injury to the cervical vertebrae as a result of judicial hanging. J. M. Ass. S. Africa, 1928, 2: 460- 2.—Wurfler P. Spattod nach Erhangen. Med. Welt, 1932, 6: 1674.—Zeitler, G. Ein Beitrag zur Kenntnis der Spattodes- falle nach Erhangen. Deut. Zschr. gerichtl. Med., 1928, 12: 380-91. ---- Recovery from. Krai, A., & Gamper, E. Korperdrehungen um die Langs- achse in der Erholungsphase bei einem wiederbelebten Er- hangten (ein Beitrag zum Automatosesyndrom Zingerles) Mschr. Psychiat., 1932-33, 84: 309-23.—Parry, L. A., & Woods, R. H. Recovery from hanging. Brit. M. J., 1935, 1: 231.—Robertson, W. G. A. Recovery after judicial hanging Ibid., 121. ---- suicidal. Otto, F. *Befunde am Halse Selbsterhangter [Halle-Wittenberg] 67p. 8? Bleicherode, 1936. Sell, W. *Mitteilung zweier durch die ntiheren Tatumstande bemerkenswerter Fade von Selbsterhangen. 34p. 8? Munch., 1931. Storch, H. D. *Psychische und nervose Storungen nach Selbstmordversuch durch Er- hangen. 12p. 8? Kiel, 1909. Descusses, M. Un suicide par pendaison original. Ann. med. leg., 1936, 16: 637-40.— Ducoste, M., & Fortineau, E. J. Fracture de la 6e cervicale au cours d'une pendaison-suicide. Ibid., 1934, 14: 907-12.—Hulst, J. P. L. [Case of suicide by hanging and swallowing cork] Ned. tschr. geneesk., 1928, 72: 695.-—Reuter, F. Erhangen in Riickenlage. Deut. med. Wschr., 1930, 56: IL—Reuter, K. Ein Fall von Erhangungs- tod. Deut. Zschr. gerichtl. Med., 1937-38, 29: 186.—Sapozh- nikov, V. S. [Cases of selfhanging] Sudeb. med. ekspertiza, 1928, 79-81.—Smirnov [Various signs of suicide by hanging] Ibid., 41-4.—Yoshimoto, S. Ein Fall von Erhangen im Liegen. Okayama igakkai zasshi, 1930, 42: 1473. HANGLEITER, Hans, 1911- * Ueber Echinococcus alveolaris; Zusammenstellung der im Pathologischen Institut der Universitat Munchen zur Sektion gekommenen Falle von Echinococcus vom Jahre 1888-1934, nebst Beschreibung eines Fades von Echinococcus alveolaris der Leber [Munchen] 45p. 21cm. Wurzb., R. Mayr, 1936. HANGMAN. Andel, M. A. van [Our colleague, the executioner] Ned. tschr. geneesk., 1925, 69: pt 2, 2100-8.—Nadel, S. F. The King's hangmen: a judicial organization in central Nigeria. Man, Lond., 1935, 35: 129-32. HANHART, Andre Gustave, 1903- *La tuberculose bovine; les moyens de la prevention; le B. C. G. [Alfort] 75p. 8? Mulhouse [n. pub.] 1932. HANHART, Eduard Paul. *Die Wirkung photodynamischer Substanzen auf die Bacteri- cidie der Sonnenstrahlen und ultraviolettreicher Lichtquellen [Zurich] 51p. 8? Frauenfeld, Huber & Co., 1928. HANHART, Ernst. *Ueber die amtliche To- tenschau auf Grund der Verhaltnisse in der verschiedenen Landern und mit besonderer Berucksichtigung der Erfahrungen im Kanton Zurich. 116p. 8? Zur., J. J. Meier, 1916. HANISCH, Elisabeth, 1909- *Beitrag zum Problem der Gangran [Munchen] 40p. 22J/2cm. Speyer, Pilger, 1938. HANISCH, Franz, 1908- *Die Infektion beim abdominellen Kaiserschnitt; ihre Ursache und Bedeutung fiir den Heilverlauf [Diisseldorf] 31p. 8? Gutersloh, Thiele, 1934. HANISCH, Sofie, 1901- *Ueber ver- gleichende Bestimmung der Kationen Na, K, Ca im Blutserum von Kranken mit hohem Blutdruck. 19p. 8? Bonn, P. Kubens, 1927. HANKE, Adolf [August Heinrich] 1906- *Untersuchungen fiber die Widerstandsfahigkeit des Schmelzes gegeniiber Sauren. 26p. 8? Bonn, Carthaus, 1929. HANKE, Emil, 1910- *Vorkommen und Verbleib von Fremdkorpern in der Zunge [Munchen] 17p. 8? Wiirzb., R. Mayr, 1934. HANKE, Hans. Innere Sekretion und Chirur- gie. xi, 326p. illust. 8? Berl., J. Springer, 1937. HANKE, Helmut, 1908- *Neue Arsen- forschungen im Dienste der Wurzelbehandlung. 19p. 8? Berl., J. Haftkowsky, 1935. HANKE, Martin, 1907- *Ueber ange- borene Geschwiilste [Tubingen] 34p. 8° Gutersloh, C. Bertelsmann, 1934. HANKE 7N IIANNE HANKi:, Millon Theodore, 1S93 Diet and dental health, xi, 235p. pl. diagrs. S° Chic, I'niv. Chicago Press [1933] HANKK. Paul H. *Kephalomctrischo Unter- suchungen am menschlichen Weicliteilkinn [Basell 2tip. 2 pl. 22' '.cm. Zur. In. pub.] 1938. HANKE, Reinhard [Richard Paul] 1896- *Beitrag zur Geschichte der Gesundheitspflege tier Ilaustiere bei den Ostasiaten (chinesische Kultur'i [Leipzig] 2(ip. 3 1. 8? [Lucka, R. Meriicr] 1923. HANKE, Viktor, 1871- Die Differential- diagnose der wichtigen Augenerkrankungen und Augenverletzungen; mit einem Anhang iiber die Brillenbestimmung. iv, 103p. 2 pl. 8? Wien, ,1. Springer, 1930. HANKE, Willy, 1907- ^Vergleichende tierexperimentelle Untersuchungen iiber die Be- einflussung der Blutbakterizidie und des Blut- ehemisnnts durch die Yitaminc A und D [Mar- burg] 23p. 8? Ellrich (Siidharz) G. Krause, 1934. HANKEN, J[oannes] H[enricus] *Ovor eenige gevolgen van temporaire ligatuur van zenuwen. H3p. pl. 23cm. Utrecht, Kemink & zoon, 1SS5. HANKIN, Ernest Hanbury, 1S65-1939. Obituary. Lancet, Lond., 1939, 1:904. HANKIN, Mabel. Doors of hope (Deus earitas est) visits to mental hospitals on the continent, viii, 52p. pl. 12? Lond., J. Bale, sons & Danielsson, 1935. HANKINS, Frank Hamilton, 1S77- The racial basis of civilization; a critique of the Nordic doctrine, x p. 2 1. 3Slp. 8? N. Y., A. A. Knopf, 1926. HANKO, Gustav, l'Kls , & KOCH, Fritz, 1909- *Ueber den Tonus der arteriellen Gefiisse unter dem Einfluss von Adrenalin und Albeit. 29p. 21cm. [Heidelb., n. pub.] 1935. HANLEY, Edna Ruth. College and university librarv buildings. 152p. inch illustr plan. 29em. Chic, Am. Libr. Ass., 1939. HANLEY, Eng. Annual reports of the sani- tary conditions of the county borough. Hanley, 1891-1901; 1906-9. HANNA. Eluzor, 1904- ""Contribution a l'etude de la prevention et du traitement des accidents de 1'aurotherapie. 51p. 8? Par , Presses Modernes, 1931. HANNA. G. Dallas, 1887- See Camp, Charles L., & Hanna, G. Dallas. Methods in paleontology. 153p. 8? Berkeley, Calif., 1937. HANNA. Henry Gabra. *De l'emploi des diuretiques mercuriels en clinique. 52p. 221-'cm. Geneve, Impr. Commerce, 1938. HANNA. William, -1941 Editor of White. C. V. Aids to sanitary science and law 3. ed.. rev. 361 p. 16}-jem. Lond., 1939. For bioginphy see Brit. M. L, 1941, 2: 142 fW. M. F. HANNAFORD, H. Eldridge. See Duke Endowment. Hospital Section. The small general hospital. 2. ed. 125p. row Sc Charlotte N C 1932. ..... HANNAH, Calvin Richards, 1872-1910. Obituary. J. Am. M. Ass., 1!M1, 116: 431. Also Texas J M., 1940-41. 36: 715. portr. HANNA-RIZK, Bastawros Ekladios. Con- tribution a l'etude du spina bifida. 40p. 221 ;ern. Geneve, Genevoise, 1939. HANNE, Heinrich, 1900- *Ueber primar- und sekundar-chronische gonorrhoische St>:Lt- arthritis. 21 p. S° Lpz., 1934. Also ZmIh. orthop. Chir., 1934, 62: HANNE. R. Wirtschaftlichkeit bei der Sterili- sation von Yerbandstoffen. 13p. X? Berl., J. Springer, 1935. HANNE, Walter Helmut, 1900 *I>er Einfluss der Eihautretention auf den Yerlauf des Wochenbettes und die lliickbildung des Uterus. 44]). S? Berl., E. Segnitz, 1935. HANNEMANN, Karl, 1890- Zur Patho- logie und Histologic der Lungon- und Pleura- verletzungen im Kriege. 237p. 10 ch. S? Berl., A. Hirschwald, 1926. Forms Heft 79, YerofT. Hed. San. HANNEMANN, Paula. * Vergleichende Unter- suchungen der Mikroreaktion nach Meinicke mit den Reaktionen naeli Wassermann und Saclis- C.eorgi. 27p. 8? Miinch., .1. Lahmaier, 1927. HANNEMUELLER, Hans Bernhard, 1910 ♦Langemvachstumsstorungen der Roh- renknochen jugendlicher bei eitriger Knochen- marksentziindung [Gottingen] J9p. 22cm. Hamb., A. Preilipper, 1937. HANNES, Walther, 1878- Die kleine Gynakologie des praktischen Arztes. 60p. 2 pi, 8? Berl., H. Kornfeld, 1927. Forms Heft 383-84, v.34, Berl. Klin. HANNICH, Willibald, 1906- ♦Unter- suchungen iiber den Einfluss von Wasser auf die menschlichen Zahne. 23p. 8? Bresl., A. Schreiber, 1934. HANNIG, Konrad, 1906- *Ueber die Lipase der Haut und der Hautdriisen [Gottin- gen] 31 p. 8? Einbeck, H. Ruttgerodt, 1930. HANNIGBRINCK, Otto, 1908- *Die VViederbefestigung lockerer Zahne. 18p. 8°. Miinch., Bayer. Dr., 1933. HANNOVER, Heinrich, 1893- *Zur Kenntnis atypischer inkonipleter Falle von Dystrophia musculorum progressiva. 27p. 8? Rostock, Adlers Erben, 1919. HANNOVER, Germ. Jiirgens. Ueber die Hannoversehe Krankheit. Zschr. klin. Med., 1928, 108: 67-89.- Oehler. Die Diakonissenanstalt Henriettenstift in Hannover. Deut. med. Wsehr., 1936, 62: 1016.—Pessler, G. Untersuchung iiber den Kinrluss dei Grosstadt auf die Kopfform sowie Beitrage zur Anthropologic und Stammeskunde Hannovers. Zschr. Morph Anthrop 1939, 38: 210-51, map.—Witte. J. Zur Ceschichte des Aerzt- lichen Vereins Hannover. Deut. med. Wsehr., 1929, 55: 859. HANNUM, Clair Arthaud, 1900- Labo- ratory manual for animal histology. 3. ed. 2 p 1 105p. illust. 21Uc:m. [Stanford Univ., Stan- ford Univ. Press] 1939. HANON, Julio L. Sobre algunos tumores de la linea media del cerebro; tesis de profesorado. 123p. illust. 25>4cm. B. Air., El Ateneo, 1937. HANOT'S cirrhosis. See Liver. HANOUNE, Simon, 1908- *Les anemies febriles aigues de l'enfance. 61 p. 8° Par C Serre, 1935. HANOVER, New Hampshire. Mary Hitch- cock Memorial Hospital. Annual reports. Hanover, 1.-9., 1893-94-1902. ---- [Circular of the treasurer, calling attention to the work and claims of the ...] Hanover (1900] HANOVIA Chemical and Manufacturing Com- pany. The basis of ultraviolet therapy for users of the Alpine and Kromayer lamps. 23p x° Newark [1940] *" ' HANOW, Gerhard, 1909- *Parese des N radialis nach Operationen am Oberarm. 31p. 8? Bresl., K. Vater, 1934. HANRION, Charles, 1907- *Les epanche- ments sero-fibrineux de la plevre dans leurs rap- ports avec la tuberculose pulmonaire lOOp 8° Par., E. Le Francois, 1936. HANRIOT 79 HANSEN HANRIOT, Maurice, 1854-1933. Delepine, M. Necrologie. Bull. Acad, med., Par., 1933, 3. ser 110: 197-202. HANS, Annelise, 1908- *Korperbau- untersuehungen an Personen im Umbildungs-, Riickbildungs- und Greisenalter. 38p. 8? Bonn, L. Neuendorff, 1933. HANS, Erich, 1912- *Blutveranderungen nach kurzdauernder schwerer und langdauernder leichterer korperlicher Arbeit. 19p. 8? Berl., E. Ebering, 1938. HANSCHKE, Paul, 1908- HTeber die Angina abdominis. 25p. 8? Heidelb., H. Fahrer, 1934. HANSCHMANN [Christian Gottlob] Lothar, 1904- *Die Behandlung uberempfindliehen Zahnbeins unter besonderer Beriicksichtigung stark jodhaltiger Pasten [Kiel] 31p. 8? Alten- burg-Thiir., R. Hiller, 1933-34. HANSE, August. Personlichkeitsgefiige und Krankheit; Grundlagen zu einer leibseelischen Ganzheitsschau und Behandlung. 192p. 23h<'m- Stuttg., Marquardt & cie, 1938. HANSE, Willi [Adolf] 1900- *Zur Stati- stik der Psoriasis vulgaris auf Grund der von 1920-25 in der Leipziger dermatologischen Klinik behandelten 241 Krankheitsfalle. 38p. 8? Lpz., E. Lehmann, 1926. HANSEL, Alfons [Karl] 1910- *Bak- teriologische Untersuchungen fiber den bakteri- ziden Wert einiger neuerer Wurzelfiill-Pasten. 26p. 8° Bresl., K. Klossok, 1938. HANSEL, French Keller, 1893- Allergy of the nose and paranasal sinuses; a monograph on the subject of allergy as related to otolaryngol- ogy. 820p. illust. pl. diagrs. roy. 8? S. Louis, C. V. Mosby Co., 1936. HANSELL, Howard Forde, 1855-1934. Shannon, C. E. G. [Obituary] Tr. Am. Ophth. Soc, 1935. 33: 21-3, portr. ------ Memoir of Dr Howard Forde Hansell, Tr. Coll. Physicians Philadelphia, 1935, 4. ser., 3: p. viii-x. HANSELMANN, Margrit. *Postoperative Thrombose und Embolie und ihre Prophylaxe durch einen Praeventiveingriff am Venensystem. 32p 8? Zur., E. & A. Kreutler, 1926. HANSEMANN, David von, 1858-1920. Ostertag, B. [Biography] Verh. Deut. path. Ges., 1937, 29: 370-8. HANSEN, Adolph, 1832?- Repetitorium der Botanik fiir Mediziner, Pharmazeuten, Lehr- amts-Kandidaten und Studierende der Forst- und Landwirtschaft. 11. Aufl. iv, 184p. 8? Giessen, A. Topelmann, 1921. HANSEN, Alfons, 1905- *Dauerresultate bei Behandlung der Epulis [Kiel] 20p. 8? Neumiinster, G. Bertheau, 1932. HANSEN, Andreas Peter, 1910- ^Unter- suchungen uber den Mechanismus der Glykokoll- wirkung auf den Blutzucker [Kiel] lip. 8? Gutersloh, Thiele, 1936. HANSEN, Bjorge. Contribution a l'etude de l'alcool yse de quelques huiles. 71 p. 3 pl. 23,2cm.' Strasb., A. Weibel, 1935. HANSEN, C. C. Anthropologia medico- historica Groenlandise antiqua? I. Herjolfsnes. p.291-547. 85 pl. 4? Kbh., 1924. Forms pt of v.67, Meddelelser om Gr0nland. HANSEN, Emanuel. *Untersuehungen uber den mechanischen Wirkungsgrad der Muskel- arbeit. 128p. 8? Berl., W. de Gruyter & co., 1927. , , ----Atmung und Kreislauf bei korperlicher Arbeit, p.835-906. Berl., .1. Springer, 1931. In 15. Bd 2. Halfte, Handb. norm. path. Physiol. (A. Bethe, (!. von Bergmann, et al.) HANSEN, Erling, 1909- *Etat actuel des mesures prises en Norvege pour la protection publique et l'assistance a, l'enfance. 80p. 8? Par., L. Arnette, 1938. HANSEN, Fr. C. C, 1870-1934. I)j0iup, T. [Obituarv] Hospitalstidende, 1934, 77: 157- 9.—Haggqvist, G. [Obituary] Hvgiea, Stockh., 1934,96:33-8, portr.—NoHund, P. [Obituarv] Hospitalstidende, 1034, 77: 185-7. HANSEN, Georg, 1908- *Ueber Zwerch- fellverletzungen durch seharfe und stumpfe Gewalt [Kiel] 45p. 8? Winsen, Gebr. Ravens, 1933. HANSEN, Gerhard Hendrik Armauer, 1841- 1912. [Biography] Nature, Lond., 1941, 148: 110.—Lie, H. P. Famous Norwegian dermatologists. Leprosy Rev., Lond., 1937, 8: 113-6, portr. HANSEN, Halldor. Pseudo-ulcus ventriculi mit besonderer Berucksichtigung der benignen Tuberkulose. xvi, 430p. roy. 8? Kbh., Levin & Munksgaard, 1932. HANSEN, Hans, 1904- *Ueber Koordi- nationseigenschaften von Halogeniden in der Nahe der Fliichtigkeitsgrenze, mit Struktur- untersuchungen an Halogeniden AX4 [Kiel] 26p. 8° Lpz. [n. pub.] 1930. Also Zschr. phys. Chem., Abt. B, 1930, 8: 1-26. HANSEN, Heinrich. *Beitrag zur serolo- gischen Schwangerschaftsdiagnostik. 13p. 8? Kiel [n. pub.] 1929. HANSEN, Helen Fredericka. A review of nursing; with outlines of subjects, questions, and answers. 2. ed. 692p. 8? Phila., W. B. Saun- ders, 1937. Also 3. ed. rev. x, 759p. 20).-'.cm. 1940. ----Reference handbook for nurses; first aid, materia medica, nursing arts, diet therapy, nurs- ing care and improvised equipment. 2 p. 1. 347p. 17K>c-.m. Phila., W. B. Saunders, 1938. HANSEN, Howard [Thorwald] 1900 *A study of cisternal puncture [Marquette Univ.] 13p. 4° Milwaukee, 1930. Typewritten. HANSEN, Jens, 1901- *Ueber Ver- letzungen durch Luft. 20p. 8? Jena, G. Neuenhahn, 1927. HANSEN, Jdrn [Klaus Detlev] 1910- *Pseudarthrose des Schenkelhalses als Folge- zustand einer Epiphysenlosung bei Osteomyelitis purulenta [Munchen] 17p. pl. 8? Wiirzb., Gebr. Memminger, 1934. HANSEN, Karl, 1893- See Praktikum der allergisehen Krankheiten: I. Das Heu- fieber oder die I'ollen-Allergie. 141p. 8! Lpz., 1930. & STAA, Hildegard v. Die einheimische Sprue und ihre Folgekrankheiten (sekundare Avitaminosen) 113p. illust. tab. ch. 8? Lpz., G. Thieme, 1936. ----Refiektorische und algetische Krank- heitszeichen der inneren Organe. viii, 270p. illust. 27cm. Lpz., G. Thieme, 1938. HANSEN, Karl [Freidrich Waldemar] 1902- *Zur Kenntnis des Kohlensuboxyds. 35p. 8? Kiel, F. Eggert, 1926. HANSEN, Klaus. Untersuchungen iiber den Einfluss des Alkohols auf die Sinnestatigkeit bei bestimmten Alkoholkonzentrationen im Orga- nismus. 114p. illust. pl. 8? Heidelb., C. Winter, 1924. ---- Zur Theorie der Narkose; Untersuchun- gen iiber die Verteilung der indifferenten Narko- tika in dem tierischen Organismus. 262p. 8? Oslo, O. Norli, 1925. HANSEN 80 HANSON HANSEN, Lester B[ryan] 1896- * Modi- fied appendicostomv [St Agnes' Hosp.] 11 1. 1? Fond du Lac, Wis., 1928. Typewritten. HANSEN, Louis A. Keeping well. 128p. 8°. Nas.hville, Southern Pub. Ass. [1925] HANSEN. Marcus Lee, 1892-1938. The Atlantic migration, 1607-1860; a history of the continuing settlement of the United States. Ed. by Arthur M. Schlesinger. xvii, 391p. pl. 22?2cm. Cambr., Mass., Harvard Univ. Press, 19-10. HANSEN, P[eder] N[ielsen] 1867- For Festskrift see Bibl. larger, 1927,119: portr. HANSEN [Peter] Friedrich, 1907- ♦Kli- nische Beobachtungen an Amyloidnieren. 22p. tab. 8? Kiel [n. pub.] 1933. HANSEN, Rowna Catherine. See Davis, Marv Dabnev. imentales sur les glycosuries et glyce'mies asphyxiques. 56p. 8? Par., M. Vigne, 1937. HARANT, Herve. See Terracol, J., Turchini, J., & Harant, H. L'appareil cartilagineux en oto-rhino-laryngologie. 216p. 8? Par., 1931. HARARI, Felix, 1904- *Syndromes sym- pathiques neurologiques et digestifs; valeurs des 227475—vol. 7, 4th series----6 HARARI S2 HARBOR Robert Maxwell, 1864 , & P. A review of 200 cases of acute 2 1. 4? [n. p.,n. pub.] tests chimio-cardiaques; tests nouveaux. 121p. s: Par., A. Legrand, 1930. HARASIM, Johannes, 1896 * Ueber das harte traumatische Oedem besonders am Fuss- riicken. 30p. 8? Bresl., K. Vater, 1934. HARASZTI, Bela, 1909- *I.st das Wiga- metall fiir zahnarztliche Zwecke verwendbar? [Berlin] 19p. 8? Jena, G. Xeuenhahn, 1935. HARAVI, Nosratollah, 1910- *Etude hydrogeologique du nord de l'Iran; considera- tions generates sur la purification des eaux de boisson. 145p. 8° Par. E. Le Francois, 1937. HARBAUGH, Charles Hamilton, 1870- The adjuster's manual for the settlement of accident and health claims. 4. ed. 3 p. 1. ix-xiv, 556]). illust. 12? X. V., Spectator Co. [1932] HARBIN, HARBIN, W abdomen with 15 deaths. 1917. HARBITZ, Francis, 1S67- Om de pato- logisk-anatomiske forandringer af neurotrofisk oprindelse. vi, 194p. 8? Kristiania, A. W. Br0gger, 1900. ----Om lymfeglandeltuberkulose og dens sammenhaeng med lungentuberkulose. 34p. roy. S? Kristiania, J. Dybwad, 1917. ----Ueber plotzlichen Tod mit natiirlicher (d. h. nicht gewaltsamer) Todesursache, insbe- sondere bei jungen Leuten; die Beurteilung derartiger Falle in der gerichtlichen Medizin. 42p. 27},km. Oslo, J. Dybwad, 1938. For biography see Norsk, mag. laegevid., 1937, 98: 561 (E. H. Hansteen) See also [Prof. Francis Harbitz' works] Ibid., 563-77. HARBITZ, Hans Fredrik, 1867- Clinical, pathogenetic and experimental investigations of endometriosis especially regarding the localisa- tion in the abdominal wall (laparotomy scars) with a contribution to the study of experimental transplantation of endometrium. 400p 29 pl S? Oslo, 1934. Forms Suppl. 30, v. 74. Acta chir. scand. HARBOLLA, Wilhelm, 1935- *Ueber Zahnreinigungsmittel unter besonderer Beruck- sichtigung von Dentipurol. 16p. 8? Wurzb., Gebr. Memminger, 1935. HARBOR [and port] See also Emigration; Quarantine; Sailor; Ship; Sanitation, &c; also in 3. ser., Ports. Hope, E. W. Health at the gateway; problems and international obligations of a seaport citv 213p. 8? Cambr., 1931. Rothfcchs, Barkow [et al.] Hygiene und Gesundheitsgefahren der Wcrft- und Hafen- urbcit und der Arbeit des Heizpersonals auf Schiffen. 48p. 8? Berl., 1928. Kisskalt, K. Untersuchungen iiber die Verunreinigung der Kieler F.irde. Arch. Hyg., Berl., 1928, 99: 99-110.—Liese W Ergebnisse der Untersuchungen uber die Verunreinigung der Kjeler Forde in den Jahren 1920 und 1927 Ibid 111-7__ Qualified ports under Article 28 of the International Sanitary Convention. Health, Canberra, 1939, 17: 5 — Struve Ver hutting der Verunreinigung von Seehafen durch die Abwrisser der SchifTe. Techn. Gemeindebl., 1937, 40: 149-51. ---- Sanitary service. Australia. Department of Health. Health organization in Australian ports. 166n 8° Canberra [1928] l Liverpool, England. Port Sanitary Au- thority Annual report of the Medical Officer of Health. Liverpool, 1910-12; 1914-17- 1922- Askew. F. Responsibilities and liabilities of Port Sanitary authorities. J. R. San. Inst., 1923-24, 44: 275-9 — Commissions sanitaires des pints. Bull. san. pub., Brux., 1938, 3: 583-6.—Domfnguez, A. G. Servicio de fumigaci6n en el Puerto de la Habana. Lev. med. cubana, 1923, 34: 654-68.—Drijon, M. I.e D. P. Health administration in a French port. -Med. Off.. Lond.. 1934, 51: 245 7. Health measures at German seaports; plague. l'ub. Health Rep., Wash., 1923, 38: 1139-41.- Kelaart, H. N. C. V. Some aspects of port health work. J. Ceylon Brit. M. Ass., 1939, 36: 127 34.— Kirvickis, J. [Sanitary measures for sea ports] Medicina, Kaunas, 1930, 11: 629-39.—Mason, J. W. Port sanitary ad- ministration. J. Prevent. M., Lond., 1906, 14: 538-42.— Maurice-Williams, H. C. Port administration. J. State M., Lond., 1931, 39: 32-45.—Peter, K. Der Hafengesundheits- dienst Hamburg, unter besonderer Berucksichtigung der Zahlen fur das Jahr 1935. Arch. Seliiffs Tropenhyg., 1936, 40: 411-25. Also Bull. Off. internat. hyg. pub., Par., 1936, 28: 1747-59. Also Reichsgesundhbl., 1936, 11: 430-4.—Port sanitation. Annual Rep. Chief M. Off. Min. Health, Lond., 1934, 239-42.—Port sanitation and common sense. Brit. M. J., 1934, 2: 366; 491.—Pringle, A. M. N. Necessity for community of action between port sanitary authorities. J. State M., Lond., 1904, 12: 321-32.—Sannemann. Hafenge- sundheitsdienst. In Hyg. u. sozial Hyg. Hamburg, 1928, 477-83.—Sastre, F., Clavero del Campo, G., & Marin de Bernardo, J. M. Bases para la adaptaeion de las funciones propias de las actualcs estaciones sanit arias de puertos y fronteras a las peculiares de los centros de higiene maritimo- sociales. Actas Congr. nac. san., Madr. (1934) 1935, 1. Congr., 1: 65-73.—Smith, W. The history of the port sanitary au- thority of Manchester. J. R. San. Inst., 1902-3, 23: 276-82.— Sorel, F. P J. Organisation et perfectionnement des services sanitaires du port de Dakar. Bull. Off. internat. hyg. pub Par., 1939, 31: 270-9.—Thompson, A. G. G. The work of a port medical officer and its relation to public health depart- mentsinland. Med. Off., Lond., 1933, 49: 135.—Villejean, A. Sur l'opportunite du rattachement au Service sanitaire mari- time dans les ports de moyenne importance; des attributions d'hygiene generate jusqu'ici devolues aux Bureaux municipaux d'hygiene; de la surveillance sanitaire des Emigrants. Rev hyg., Par., 1920, 42: 786-90.------Sur l'application des dispositions de la Convention sanitaire internationale de 1926 relatives k l'outillage sanitaire des ports: l'annuaire sanitaire maritime international. Rapp. Congr. internat. hyg. m6diter (1932) 1933, 1. Congr., 2: 607.—White, C. F. The routine boarding of ships from infected ports. Med. Off., Lond., 1932, 47: 255.------A review of port sanitary administration. J. R. San. Inst., 1934, 54: 459-70. ------ The work of a port medical officer. S. Thomas Hosp. Gaz., Lond., 1937-38, 36: 346; 421.—Williamson, W. H. Address to conference of Port Sanitary Authorities, Brighton Congress. J. R San Inst., 1910-11, 31: 598-602.—Wolff, E. Der Gesundheits- dienst in den bremischen Hiifen. Reichsgesundhbl., 1936, 11: 449-51. Also Bull. Off. internat. hyg. pub., Par., 1936, 28: 1760-4 ------ Die Aufgaben des Hafenarztes, im besonderen im Verkehr mit den Schiffsarzten. In Schiffs & Hafenarzt (Kortenhaus, F.) Jena, 1937, 175-80. HARBORD, James G. The American Expe- ditionary Forces; its organization and accom- plishments. 3 1. 95p. portr. 8? [Evanston, 111.] Evanston Pub. Co., 1929. HARBURGER, Juliette, 1894- *Con- tribution a l'etude de la frequence et de la gravite de la cirrhose alcoolique chez la femme 32p. 8? Par., Jouve & cie, 1934. HARBURGER, Michel Adrien, 1898- *La resection atypique des tumeurs du maxillaire mfeneur par les voies naturelles (tumeurs d origine dentaire exceptees) a la demande des lesions. 48p. 8? Par., L. Arnette, 1927. HARDAWAY, William Augustus, 1850-1923. Manual of skin diseases; with special reference to diagnosis and treatment. vi, 434p 12° S. Louis, T. F. Lange, 1890. HARDE, Heinz, 1904- *Der NaCl- Lrehalt des Harns gesunder und kranker Schweine. ^6p. 8. Lpz., A. Edelmann, 1932 HARDE, Hildegard, 1903- *Die ver- schiedenen Formen der Mastitisbehandlung [fglS P' 8? Quakenbruck> R- Kleinert HARDEGEN, Ada, 1911- *Beobach- tungen zur Klinik und Behandlung der weib- hchen feterditat. 41p. tab. 8? Lpz., J. Moltzen, 1937. a J1 AR?EGEN, Martha, 1912- *Ueber Schadelbasisbruche und ihreNacherscheinungen, unter Beriicksichtigung von 26 in der Chi- rurgischen Khnik der Universitat Rostock zur HARDEGEN 83 HARDGROVE Nachuntersuchung erschienenen Patienten [Ros- tock] 25p. 22)/2cm. Emsdetten, H. & J. Lechte, 1937. HARDEGGER, Armin. *Die Verbreitung des Typhus abdominalis in der Schweiz in den Jahren 1910-29. 35p. 2 maps. 8? Basel, Gebr. Strobel, 1932. HARDEGGER, Bertha. *Verbreitung des Kropfes bei den Schulkindern von Basel und Riehen im Jahre 1930 [Basel] 34p. 8? Lachen [n. pub.] 1930. HARDEN, Sir Arthur, 1865- Alcoholic fermentation. 4. ed. vii, 243p. 8° Lond., Longmans, Green & Co., 1932. See also Presentation of an inscribed salver. Biochem. J., Lond., 1938, 32: 769-74, pl. HARDEN, Maximilian, 1861- Cornelius. Analyse der Handschrift Maximilian Hardens. Zschr. Menschenk., 1925-26, 1: H. 3, 37-41. HARDEN, Paul, 1911- *R6ntgenbe- strahlungbei Halslymphdrusentuberkulose. 19p. 8? Erlangen, Junge & Sohn, 1937. HARDENBERG, Friedrich Leopold von, 1772- 1801. Bltjth, K. T. Medizingeschichtliches bei Novalis; ein Beitrag zur Geschichte der Medizin der Romantik. 59p. 8? Berl., 1934. HARDENBERGH, William Andrew, 1888- Sewerage and sewage treatment. xi, 396p. illust. pl. diagrs. 8? Scranton, Pa., Internat. Textbook Co. [1936] ---- Purification of water. 2 pts in 1 v. Scranton, Internat. Textbook Co. [1938] ---- Operation of sewage-treatment plants. Pts 1-3. v, 219p. illust. pl. tab. diagr. 19cm. Scranton, Internat. Textbook Co. [1939] HARDER, Gerhard, 1912- *Die Misch- geschwulste der Parotis mit besonderer Beruck- sichtigung der in den letzten neun Jahren in der Chirurgischen Klinik zu Munchen behandelten Falle. 24p. 8? Miinch., C. Wolf & Sohn, 1937. HARDER, Johfann] Friedrich, 1897- *Beitrag zur Frage der kunstlichen Fehlgeburt und Sterilisation (bearbeitet nach dem Materia] der Kieler Klinik 1928-31) 32p. 8? Kiel, H. Ludtke, 1932. HARDER, Max. *Klinik des Dickdarmcar- cinoms unter besonderer berucksichtigung der Radikal operationen [Kiel] 51p. 8? Bochum, H. Poppinghaus, 1934. HARDERS, Joachim, 1913- *Beitrage zur Kenntnis der Pyelitis und deren Folge- zustande rBerlin] 26p. 22cm. Quakenbriick, R. Kleinert, 1938. HARDER'S gland See also Lacrimal apparatus; Nictitating mem- brane. J „ ,.,,*. Costantini, A. Ricerche sulla secrezione della ghiandola di Harder. Pathologica, Genova, 1933, 25: 836-40.—Duthie, E. S. Studies on the cytology of the Harderian gland of the rat. Q. J. Micr. Sc, Lond., 1934, 76: 549-57— Kamocki, W. [On the so-called Harder's gland] Rozpr. wydz. mat. przyrod. Polska Akad., 1882, 9: 204-44— Lacroix. E De 1 existence des cellules en paniers dans la glande de Harder. Province med., Lyon, 1895, 9: 244-6.—Loewenthal, N. Observations sur la membrane nictitante et le cartilage de la glande de Harder du cameleon. Arch, anat., Strasb., 193D-37, £i: 315-22—Mukai, H. Ueber die feinere Stmktur der Harder- schen Druse beim Kaninchen. Arch. Ophth., Berl., 192b, 117- 243-72—Sundwall, J- The structure of the Harderian glands of the ox. Anat. Rec, 1906-7, 1: 72. HARDERWYCK, Gerard, 1503- Epi- tomata totius naturalis philosophiae; or, Repara- tiones. 340 1. 4? Koln, H. Quentell, Feb. 29, 1496. HARDGROVE, Thomas J., 1905- *Sub- arachnoid block [Wisconsin Univ.] 14p. 4? Fond du Lac, Wis., 1931. Typewritten. HARDIN, Lewis Sage, 1873-1937. Hall, O. D., Clifton, B. H., & Shackleford, B. L. Resolutions on the death of Dr Lewis Sage Hardin. J. M. Ass. Georgia, 1938, 27: 71. HARDIN, Ronda Horton, 1892-1937. Cocke, C. H. Obituary. Ann. Int. M., 1937-38, 11: 1388. HARDING, Sir Charles O'Brien, 1859-1929. Obituary. Brit. M. J., 1925, 1: 1101. HARDING, Mary Esther, 1888- The way of all women; a psychological interpreta- tion, xv, 335p. 8? Lond., Longmans, Green & Co., 1933. ---- Woman's mysteries, ancient and modern. xvi, 342p. illust. 8? Lond., Longmans, Green & Co., 1935. HARDING, Thomas Swann, 1890- Fads, frauds and physicians; diagnosis and treatment of the doctors' dilemma. 5 p. 1. 409p. 8? N. Y., L. MacVeagh, 1930. ---- Another Jew without money [Joseph Goldberger, M. D.] p. 166-70. 8? [n. p.] 1931. Cutting from Atlantic Monthly, 1931, 148: No. 2. HARDING, Victor John, 1885-1934. Obituary. Biochem. J., Lond., 1935, 29: 1-4. HARDMEIER, Ernst, 1904- *Akute und subakute Vergiftungen und Unglucksfalle bei der Arbeit im Innern von Reservoiren: die Schutzmassnahmen; die versicherungsrechtliche und die strafrechtliche Verantwortung. 82p. 8? Zur., O. Fussli, 1935. HARDMEIER, Hans. *Die medizinischen Anschauungen der sudamerikanischen Indianer. 104p. 8? Zur., O. Fussli, 1927. HARDMEYER, Ernst, 1903- Unter- suchungen iiber die Reaktion der Haut auf Bestrahlung mit weissem Licht. 38p. 8? Zur., Gebr. Leemann & Co., 1932. HARD-of-hearing. See Deaf. HARDOUIN, Andre, 1911- *La prophy- laxie aetuelle du tetanos; opportunity de la scrotherapie preventive. 55p. 8? Par., Jouve & cie, 1937. HARDOUIN, Henry Jacques. Avec les Blues du ler Grenadier de France. 601p. map. 12? Par., E. Figuiere [1934] HARDOUIN, Pierre, 1907- Contribu- tion a l'etude de l'evacuation des ordures mena- geres dans le milieu urbain. 56p. 8? Par., M. Lac, 1932. HARDRE, Jean Louis, 1914- *Psychoses puerp£rales colibacillaires. 32p. 24cm. Par., M. Lavergne, 1939. HARDT. Die Preugo; Preussische Gebiih- renordnung fiir approbierte Aerzte und Zahn- arzte vom 1. September 1924. 9. Aufl. 129p. 12? Berl., Deut. Aerzteschaft, 1937. HARDT, Hanns, 1910- *Experimentelle Untersuchungen iiber Dysentulin (ein neues Desinfektionsmittel und Spezifikum in der Be- handlung der Amobenruhr) 23p. 8? Munster i. W., Regensberg, 1935. HARDT, Hans Leopold, 1911- * Ver- suche iiber die Luftbefeuchtung von grossen Raumen. 23p. 20^cm. Konigsb.-Pr., J. Raabe, 1936. HARDT S4 HARE HARDT, Hilmar, 1911- *Die histolo- gische und klinische Bedeutung der Abrasionen und ihre Behandlung. 55p. 8? Wiirzb., R. Ma vi, 1933. HARDTMANN Garcia, Helmut. *CariesJ calcio y embarazo [Chile] 59p. 2(i';em. San- tiago, Impr. Condor, 1938. HARDY, Albert Victor, 1897 Notes and references on personal and communitv hygiene. Pt 2. 121 1. roy. 8? Iowa Citv, la'., Univ. Iowa Dep. Hyg. & Prev. Med., 1933. ---- Brucellosis in the United States, p.57- 101. 23>km. X. Y., 1939. In Brucellosis in man"and animals (I. F. Huddleson [et al.] N. Y. 1939. See also Huddleson, I. F., Hardy, A. V. [et al.] Brucellosis in man and animals. 399p. 23J^cm. X. Y. 1939. HARDY, Alfred, 1811-93. Beeson, B. B. [Biography] Arch. Derm. Svph., Chic, 1930, 21: 108 11, portr. HARDY, Gerard, 1910- *La roentgen- therapie dans le traitement des affections inflam- matoires du revetement cutane. 50p. 8? Par., Maloine, 1936. HARDY, Irvin, 1873-1926. Obituary. J. Am. AL Ass., 1926, 86: 640. HARDY, John A. A synopsis of the diagnosis of the acute surgical diseases of the abdomen. 245p. illust. 8? Lond., H. Kimpton, 1938. HARDY, Louis Marie, 1S96- *Du traite- ment des tuberculeux diabStiques par l'insuline et le pneumothorax artificiel. 41 p. pl. 8? Par., L. Arnette, 1929. HARDY, Martha Crumpton, & HOEFER, Carolyn H. Healthy growth; a study of the in- fiuenceof health education on growth anddevelop- ment of school children, xii, 360p. tab. ch. 8? Chic, Univ. Chicago Press [1936] HARDY, Roger, 1907- *Les indurations plastiques des corps caverneux; leur traitement. 13Sp. 8? Par., Mouvsset, 1931. HARDY, William Bate, 1864-1934. To re- mind; a biological essay, xi, 45p. 8? Bait., Williams & Wilkins Co., 1934. ----Collected scientific papers of Sir William Bate Hardy [xi] 922p. illust. pl. portr. diagrs. roy. 8? Cambr., Univ. Press, 1936. For portrait, photograph see collection in library. For biography see Biochem. J., Lond., 1934, 28: 1149-52. HARE, Earle R., 1872-1934. Benjamin, A. E. [Obituarv] Tr. West. Surg. Ass., 1934, 44: 524, portr.—Obituary. Minnesota M., 1934, 17: 353. HARE, Edward Selleck, 1812-38. Fulton, J. F. Edward Selleck Hare (1812-38) and the syn- drome of paralysis of the cervical svmpathetic. Proc. R. Soc M., Lond., 1929-30, 23: Sect. Hist. AL, 152-4. HARE, Francis Washington Everard, 1858- 1928. Obituary. Lancet, Lond., 1928, 2: 1319. HARE, Hobart Amory, 1862-1931. Questions and answers on the essentials of physiology pre- pared especially for students of medicine, viii 170p. 12? Phila., W. B. Saunders, 1888. Also 2. ed. x, 193p. 1889. ----Practical diagnosis: the use of symptoms in the diagnosis of disease. 4. ed. x, 631p S° Phila., Lea Bros & Co., 1899. ----The same. Symptoms in the diagnosis of disease. 8. ed., rev. xii, 562p. illust. 9 pl 24)2cm. Phila., Lea & Febiger, 1920. ---- The same. The use of symptoms in the diagnosis of disease. 9. ed. xii, 528p. 4 pl. 8° Phila., Lea & Febiger, 1928. ----A text-book of practical therapeutics; with especial reference to the application of remedial measures to disease and their employ- ment upon a rational basis. 20. ed. x, 1094p. 8 pl. roy. 8? Phila., Lea & Febiger, 1927. Arso 21. ed. x, 1104p. 6 pl. 1930. Lor portrait, photograph, see collection in library. For biography sec Pennsylvania M. J., 1931, 34: 722-4. Also Tr. Coll. Physicians Philadelphia, 1932, 54: p. lxxii-lxxv (T. AlcCrae) HARE, Robert, 1781-1858. Portrait. In Hist. Chem. (Moore, F. J.) 3. ed., N. Y., 1939, 87.—Smith, K. F. An early American chemist. Arch.stor.se, 1927, 8: 330 5, portr. HARE, Robert, pseud See Hutchinson, Robert Hare. The doctor's first murder. 288p. 8? Lond., [1933] HARE, Robert Ammiel, 1889- See Sansum, W. D., Hare, R. A., & Bowden, R. The normal diet and healthful living. 243p. 8? N. Y., 1936. HARE. For other genus of Leporidae see Rabbit. Dice, L. R. Notes on Hypolagus browni and Lepus ben- jamini, fossil hares from the pleistocene of Arizona. Papers Alichigan Acad. Sc, 1932, 16: 379-82.—OU, A. Das bosartige Ekzem des Hasen (Lepus europaeus) eine Form der Staphylo- mykose. Arch. wiss. prakt. Tierh., 1931, 63: 120-35. ------ Ueber das seuchenhafte Auftreten der Rodentiose unter den Hasen. Zschr. Infektkr. Haustiere, 1937-38, 52: 89-107.— Spinelli, A., & Penso, G. Setticopioemia della lepori a carattere epizootico. Clin, vet., Milano, 1932, 55: 173-89. HAREFUAH; the medical journal of the Palestine Jewish Medical Association. Tel- Aviv, v.2, 1927- V.7-11, 1933-36, missing. HAREL, Robert Marie Joseph, 1909- *Contribution a l'etude de l'avortement; etude statistique et the>apeutique. 59p. 8? Par., Le Francois, 1938. HARELIP. See under Lip; also Face, Coloboma. HARET, Georges, 1874-1932, DARIAUX, Andre [et al.] Atlas de radiographic osseuse. 2v. 343p. paged consec. fol. Par., Masson & cie, 1931. Also 2. ed. v.l, 149 pl. 1932. For biography see Bull. Soc radiol. mid. France, 1933, 21: Suppl., 1-23, portr. (de Fontenay, Mourier [et al.]) Also J. radiol. electr., 1933, 17: p. iii, portr. (J. Belot) HARFF, Anton, 1907- *Ein Fall von maligner Degeneration eines Navus pigmentosus conjunctivae. 16p. 8? Wiirzb., Handelsdr., 1933. HARFF, Joachim, 1910- *Tintenstiftver- letzung. 19p. 23cm. Berl., F. Linke, 1937. HARFST, Hermann, 1911- *Besteht ein Einfluss der Gezeiten (Ebbe und Flut) oder des Mondes auf die Geburt? [Kiel] 23p. 23}£cm. Delmenhorst, H. Brandt, 1935. HARGER, John. Cancer: its causation, pre- vention and cure, xv, 139p. 12? Liverp.. G. Tinling & Co., 1924. HARGITT, George T. See Hargitt, Charles Wesley, & Hargitt, George T. Outlines of general biology. 5. ed. 192p. 8? Phila., 1925. HARGRAVE, Gordon J. The right way of sizing up people at sight and basic laws of success. 3v. 8? Chic. [n. pub.] 1920. HARGRAVE, John C, 1876- Dr John C. Hargrave retires. Canad. J. Comp. M., 1941, 5: 144. ' ' HARGRAVE-WILSON, W[illiam] See Macdonald, George, & Hargrave-Wilson, W. The osteopathic lesion. 141p. 8? Lond., 1935. HARI, Pal, 1869-1933. Kurzes Lehrbuch der physiologischen Chemie. 3. Aufl. xi, 407p. 8? Berl., J. Springer, 1928. For biography see Budapesti orv. ujs., 1933, 31: 464. Also Gyfgyaszat, 1933, 73: 334 (L. Levy) Also Magv orv arch 933 34: 359-61 (S. Belak) Also Orv. hetil ,S1933 77: 415 (U. Parkas) For portrait, photograph see collection in library. HARI 85 HARLOCK See also Deutsch, B. [Scientific research of Pdl Hdri] Gy6gydszat, 1933, 73: 575. HARING, C[larence] M[elvin] 1878- , & MEYER, K. F. Investigation of livestock con- ditions and losses in the Selby Smoke Zone. p.474-502. 3 pl. 8? Wash., Gov. Print. Off., 1915. HARING, Wilhelm. Die Erkrankungen der Bauchspeicheldrtise im Rontgenbilde [Habilita- tionsschrift; Halle] p.409-58. 8? Lpz., Thieme [1932] Also Erg. med. Strahlenforsch., 1933, 6: HARINGER, Jakob. Flinker, R. Jakob Haringer; eine psychopathologische Untersuchung iiber die Lyrik. Arch. Psychiat., Berl., 1937, 107: 347-99. HARINGTON, Charles Robert, 1897- The thyroid gland; its chemistry and physiology. xii p.; 222p. illust. pl. diagrs. 8? Lond., Oxford Univ. Press, 1933. HARISPE, Denise, 1907- *Contribu- tion a l'etude du metabolisme maximum ou metabolisme de sommet. 81 p. 8? Par., J. Peyronnet & cie, 1937. HARK, Ann. Hex marks the spot, in the Pennsylvania Dutch country. 316p. illust. 21cm. Phila., J. B. Lippincott Co. [1938] HARKAVY, Alexander, 1863- Complete English-Jewish dictionary, with the pronuncia- tion of every word in Hebrew characters. 6. ed. 2v. vii, 759p.; 364p. 8? N. Y\, Hebrew Pub. Co. [1891] HARKE [Anton Conrad] Erich, 1900- *Kritische Betrachtung iiber Verwendung und Berstellung bandloser Metallkronen. 22p. 8? Gott., Gott. Handelsdr., 1931. HARKE, Gunter, 1906- *Klinische Un- tersuchungen in einer Sippe eines Kranken mit pernizioser Anamie. 34p. 8? Frankf. a. M., K. Osswald, 1938. HARKE, Walter [Julius] 1907- Unter- suchungen fiber die Beeinflussung der von Groer-Hecht'schen Hautreaktionen durch Son- nen- und Seebader. 18p. 8? Rostock, C. Hinstorff, 1934. HARKINS, Malcolm J. See Greenbaum, S. S., & Harkins, AL J. An experimental study of the prophylaxis of syphilis l&c] p.409-13. 8? Chic, 1924. HARLOCK, Walter E. See Wenstrom, O. Edmund, & Harlock, W. E. A Swedish- English dictionary, new impression with reformed Swedish spelling. 844p. 8? Stockh. [1935] HARLOS, Charlotte, 1909- *Ueber den quantitativen Nachweis des Atropins auf bio- logischem Wege. lOp. 3 1. 8? Halle, C. F. Rode & Sohn, 1933. HARMAN, Mary Theresa, 1877- A textbook of embryology, xiii, 476p. 8? Phila., Lea & Febiger, 1932. HARMAN, Nathaniel Bishop, 1869- Aids to ophthalmology. 6. ed. viii, 226p. 16cm. Lond., Bailliere, Tindall & Cox, 1919. Also 8. ed. viii, 242p. illust. 1935. Also 9. ed., rev. by P. McG. Moffatt. viii, 284p. inch illust. diagr. 1940. ----Science and religion. [175]p. 8? Lond., G. Allen & Unwin, 1935. HARMEL, Hans Dietrich, 1911- *Wie oft kommen metastatische Parotisabszesse bei Magenresektionen vor? 28p. 23cm. Berl., R. Pfau, 1938. HARMELIN, Marthe, 1895- *Etude du chimisme gastrique chez le nourrisson. 66p. 8? Par., L. Arnette, 1925. HARMER, Bertha. Methods and principles of teaching the principles and practice of nursing. ix, 136p. 8? N. Y., Macmillan Co., 1926. ----Text-book of the principles and practice of nursing. 2. ed. xix, 738p. 22cm. N. Y., MacMillan Co., 1928. Also 3. ed. xx, 846p. illust. diagrs. 1934. Also 4. ed. with Virginia Henderson, xi, 1047p. illust. pl. tab. diagr. [1939] HARMER, William Douglas, 1873- The relative value of radiotherapy in the treatment of cancers of the upper air-passages, University of London Semon lecture, delivered at the Royal Society of Medicine on November 5, 1931. vi, 85p. illust. pl. 8? Lond., J. Murray [1932] HARMINE [and related compounds] See also Banisteria; Peganum. Bakhsh, I. The pharmacological actions of indol-N- methylharmine. Q. J. Pharm., Lond., 1936, 9: 37-47 — Briickl, K., & Mussgnug, F. Ueber die Identitat von Harmin und Banisterin. Munch, med. Wschr., 1929, 76: 1078 — Chen, A. L., & Chen, K. K. Harmine, the alkaloid of caapi. Q. J. Pharm., Lond., 1939, 12: 30-8.—Coulthard, C. E., Levene, H. H. L., & Pyman, F. L. The chemotherapy of derivatives of harmine and harmaline. Biochem. J., Lond., 1933, 27: 727; 1934, 28: 264.—Decourt, J., & Lemaire, A. La yageme ou harmine; nouveau medicament symptomatique de la raideur et de l'akinesie parkinsoniennes. Paris med., 1930, 77: 505-10.—Decourt, J., Azerad, E., & Bonnard. Y. L'action de l'harmine sur la glycemie, la reserve alcaline et le metabolisme basal. C. rend. Soc. biol., 1930, 104: 1209 — Elphick, G. K., & Gunn, J. A. The pharmacological actions of some alkyl derivatives of harmol; propyl-harmol. Q. J. Pharm., Lond., 1932, 5: 34-47. ------ The pharmacological actions of some alkvl derivatives of harmol; nonyl-harmol. Ibid., 63-71.—Faure-Beaulieu, M., & Cord, M. L'harmine, nouvelle medication anti-parkinsonienne. Rev. mid. fr., 1931, 12: 445-7.—Flury, F. Ueber Harmin beziehungsweise Banisterin. Miinch. med. Wschr., 1929, 76: 1172.—Frank, H., & Schlesinger, O. Klinische Erfahrungen bei der Be- handlung der postencephalitischen Erscheinungen mit Harmin. Klin. Wschr., 1930, 9: 1864-6.—Gunn, J. A. Some pharma- cological actions of banisterine (harmine) Lancet, Lond., 1929, 1: 1140-2. ------ & Heathcote, R. St. A. The pharma- cological actions of some alkyl derivatives of harmol; ethyl harmol. Q. J. Pharm., Lond., 1931, 4: 549-65.—Gunn, J. A., & MacKeith, M. H. The pharmacological actions of some alkyl derivatives of harmol. Ibid., 1932, 5: 48-55.—Gunn, J. A., & MacKeith, R. C. The pharmacological actions of harmol. Ibid., 1931, 4: 33-51.—Gunn, J. A., & Simonart, A. J. L. The pharmacological actions of harmalol. Ibid., 1930, 3: 218-37.—Halpern, L. Der Wirkungsmechanismus des Harmins und die Pathophysiologic der Parkinsonschen Krankheit. Deut. med. Wschr., 1930, 56: 651-5. ------ Ueber die Harminwirkung im Selbstversuch. Ibid., 1252-4.— Kadoyama, C. Wirkung des Harmans auf das Zentralnerven- HARLAN, William J., 1874-1940. Obituary. Texas J. M., 1940-41, 36: 276. HARLEFS, Chr. Friedr. Die Verdienste der Frauen um Xaturwissenschaft und Heilkunde. xvi, 296p.; 83p. pl. 8? Gott., Vandenhoelz- Ruprecht, 1830. HARLEY (A) Street doctor. A Doctor's diary. 253p. 8? Lond. [192-?] HARLEY, George, 1829-96. Tweedie, E. George Harley, F. R. S., the life of a physician. 360p. 8? Lond., 1899. Scientist and physician. Med. J. & Rec, 1929, 129: 702-4. HARLEY, John, 1833-1921. On the action of fool's parsley (^Ethusa cynapium) 26p. pl. [n. p., n. pub., n. d.] HARLFINGER, Amalie, 1912- *Ein- fluss der Rachitis auf Zahne und Kiefer. 27p. 8? Bonn, H. Trapp, 1936. HARLINGHAUSEN, Eva [Irene] 1897- *Gicht und Blutkrankheiten [Kiel] 30p. 8? Lippstadt, O. Harlinghausen, 1933. HARLINGHAUSEN, Heinrich, 1910- *Ueber die Notwendigkeit operativen Vorgehens bei den entziindlichen und nicht entziindlichen Erkrankungen der Oberkieferhohle [Munchen] 22p. 8? Wiirzb., R. Mayr, 1936. HARMINE 86 HARMS system. Tohoku J. Exp. M., 1931, 17: 1-9.------Wirkung des Harmans auf die Atmung und den Krcislauf. Ibid., 10-9. ■-----Ueber die Giftigkeit einigcr Harmanderivate fur Regenwiirmer. Ibid., 28-30.—Konowalowa, R., & OrechofT. A. Untersuchungen in der Reihe des Harmins und Harmalins; uber die N-Alkylderivate des Harmins und Harmalins. Arch. Pharm.. Berl., 1934, 272: 748-61.— Legrand. A.. & Lamelin, P. Action de l'harmine sur les echanges rcspiratoircs; recherches cliniques et expeLimentales. C. rend. Soc. biol., 1930, 105: 945-7.—Marinesco, G., Kreindler, A., & Scheim, A. Klinische und experimentelle Beitrage zur Pharmakologie des Harmins. Arch. exp. Path., Lpz., 1930, 154: 301-16- Miyake, S. Ein- fluss des Harmalin auf den Blutzucker- und Bhitkalkspiegel des Kaninchens. Okayama igakkai zasshi, 1936, 48: 2479.— Penta, P., & Aveta, A. L'azione combinata dell'armina e della bulbocapnina sui gatti. Riv. neur., 1938, 11: 31-54.— Pereira, J. R., & Aranha Pereira, A. Accao simpatomimetica da harmina. Ann. Fac. med. S. Paulo, 1931. 6: 47-50, 6 pl.— Petersen, S., & Winther, K. [Harmine—a new remedy in extrapyramidal musoular rigidity] Ugeskr. heger, 1932, 94: 727-30.- Ponirovsky, M. G., & Ishunina, V. S. [Harmin and vegetative functions of the organism; effect of harmin on the temperature and general condition of the organism] Ukrain. med. arkh., 1932, 8: 35—41.—Risi, A. Ricerche farmacologiche sull'armina. Fisiol. & med., Roma, 1931, 2: 73-121.—Sala, G. L'azione deH'armina sull'occhio. Arch, ottalm., 1931, 38: 197-202. ■—---- Studio farmacologico Mill azione dell'armina sull'occhio. Ibid., 1932, 39: 261-78.—Sato, M. Ueber die Entstehung der Schwimm- und Laufbewegungen durch das Harman und seine Derivate. Tohoku J.Exp. M., 1935, 26: 161-3. ------& Sivori, P. N. Acci6n vascular y respiratoria del clorhidrato de harmina (banisterina) Rev. As. mid. argent., 1932, 45: 1518-22.—Shmelkin, D. G., & Feldman, A. B. [Effect of harmine on the psveho-motor centers] Sovet. psikhonevr., 1933, 9: 109-12—Srutek, J. [Effect of harmin on the isolated muscle and heart of the frog] Cas. 16k. Cesk., 1934, 73: 180-5.—Takase, T., Kadoyama, C, & Obara, R. Wirkung einiger Harmanderivate und die Beziehung der ersteren zur Konstitution der letzteren. Tohoku J. Exp. M., 1931, 17: 20-4.—Tomescu, P., & Russu. E. [Tests on the therapeutic effect of harmine in the catatonic syndrome] Spitalul. 1930, 50: 209-13. HARMOLIN, Max S. State board questions in chiropody; to serve as an aid to students and practitioners of chiropody, viii, 288p. 19cm. Bait., W. Wood & Co., 1938. HARMON, Daniel Warwick, 1880-1940. P[halen] J. M. Obituary. Mil. Surgeon, 1941, 88: 86. HARMON, Francis L. *The effects of noise upon certain psychological and physiological processes. 81p. 8? N. Y., R. S. Woodworth, 1933 HARMON, Samuel E., 1871-1935. Routh, F. M. Memorial address; Dr Samuel E. Harmon. J. S. Carolina M. Ass., 1936, 32: 124. HARMONICS. See Music; Sound. HARMOSTOMIDAE. See also Trematoda. Alicata, J. E. The life cycle of Postharmostomum gallinum, the cecal fluke of poultry. J. Parasit., Lancaster, 1940, 26: 135- 43.—Dickerson, L. M. A new variety of Harrnostomum opis- thotrias from the North American opossum, Didelphys vir- giniana, with a discussion of its possible bearing on the origin of its host. Parasitology, Lond., 1930, 22: 37-46.—Joyeux C, Baer, J. G., & Timon-David, J. Recherches sur le cycle fivolutif des trematodes appartenant au genre Brachylcemus Dujardin (syn. Harrnostomum Braun) C. rend. Acad, sc, 1932, 195: 972. ------ Recherches sur les trematodes du genre Brachy- laemus Dujardin (svn. Harrnostomum Braun) Bull. biol. Par 1934,68:385-418, pl— Sinitsin, D. Studien uber die Phylogenie der Trematoden; revision of Harmostominae in the light of new facts frcm their morph ologv and life history. Zschr. Parasitenk 1930-31, 3: 786-835, 6 pl.—Travassos, L. Harrnostomum de la Columba livia Dom. C. rend. Soc. biol., 1927 97: 844-6. HARMS, Christian [Olof Johannes Georg] 1904- *Statistik der malignen Tumoren nach dem Sektions-material 1919-28 [Kiel] p.158-73. 8? Berl., J. Springer, 1930. Also Zschr. Krebsforsch., 1930-31, 33: HARMS, Christoph Jelde, 1877-1941. [Obituary] Deut. Tuberk. Bl., 1941, 15: 53, portr. HARMS, Jiirgen, 1910- *Ueber die Beziehungen von Hydrops. 19p. 23cm. Kiel H. Ludtke, 1936. HARMS, Margaretha, 1910- *Gibt es charakteristische Merkmale im menschlichen Gebiss, die fiir die Physiognomic und die Beur- teilung des Charakters von Bedeutung sein ktinnen? 52p. 8° Berl., R. Pfau, 1937. HARMS, Paul, 1907- *Blutregenerations- cm. Cedar Rapids, Torch Press [19411 HARPER, Paul Tompkins. 1881- Clinical obstetrics, xix, 629p. 84 pl. 8? Phila., F. A. Davis Co., 1930. HARPER, Ralph Moore, 1882- The voice governor, give it a chance; correct body mechanics does it. xi, 142p. illust. 21cm. Bost., E. C. Schirmer Music Co. [1940] HARPER Hospital bulletin. Detr., v.1-14, 1890-1904; n. ser., v.3-5, 1923-26. HARPER-SHOVE, F. Prescriber and clinical repertory of medicinal herbs, xii, 199p. 19cm. [Lond.] Homoeopathic Pub. Co. [1938] HARPOGRAPHIUM. See Stilbaceae. HARPOLE, James, pseud. Leaves from a surgeon's case-book. xii, 261p. 8? Lond., Cassell [1938] ---- Body menders, xii, 296p. 22J^cm. N. Y., F. A. Stokes Co., 1939. ---■ Behind the surgeon's mask, xii, 308p. 22^cm. N. Y., F. A. Stokes [1940] HARPPRECHT, Heinrich, 1909- *Ueber die Beziehungen der Fibrosis cystica mammae zu Fibroadenom und Carcinom [Tubingen] 71p. 8? Winsen, Gebr. Ravens, 1934. HARPPRECHT [Karl Johannes] Kurt, 1909- *Ueber angeborene Oesophagusstenose [Kiel] 40p. 2 pl. 8? Bordesholm, H. H. Nolke, 1934. HARPSTER, Charles Melvin, 1873-1926. Obituary. J. Am. M. Ass., 1927, 88: 187. HARPUR, Caldwell. Count by 10: an easy explanation of the advantages of the metric system. 7p. 8? [Lond., n. pub., n. d.] HARRAH, Ezra Clarence, 1889- See Jean, Frank Covert, Harrah, Ezra Clarence, & Herman, Fred Louis. Introduction to science. Book 2, pt 1. 197p. 8! Greeley, Colo., 1933. HARRAR, James Aitken, 1877- The story of the Lying-in Hospital of the city of New York, ix, 1, 83p. illust. portr. facs. 8? N. Y., Soc. Lying-in Hosp., 1938. HARREVELD, Anthonie van. *Het electro- gram van de glandula submaxillaris. 141p. pl. 8? Amst., P. H. Vermeulen, 1929. HARRIES, D. G. See Boome, E. J., Baines, H. M. S., & Harries, D. G. Abnormal speech. 162p. 19cm. Lond., 1939. HARRIES, E[ric] Hfenry] R[hys] & MITMAN, M. Clinical practice in infectious diseases; for students, practitioners and medical officers, xii, 468p. illust. tab. 22Hcm. Edinb., E. & S. Livingstone, 1940. HARRIES, Friedrich, 1908- *Ueber die Temperaturempfindlichkeit der Schleimhaut des harten und weichen Gaumens. 21p. 8? Wurzb., R. Mayr, 1934. I HARRIGAN, William Leroy, 1900- *The use of glucose solutions, intraperitoneally, to promote drainage in acute, general peritonitis [Marquette Univ.] lOp. 4? Milwaukee, 1926. Typewritten. HARRIMAN, Philip Lawrence. See Skinner, C. E., & Harriman, P. L. Child psychology, child development and modern education. 522p. 22cm. N. Y., 1941. HARRINGTON, Arthur Hudson, 1856-1939. Munro, W. L. Obituary. Rhode Island M. J., 1939, 22: 105-8. HARRINGTON, D[aniel] 1878- Coal- mine explosions and coal- and metal-mine fires in the United States during the fiscal year ended June 30, 1939. 21p. 4? [Wash., 1939] Forms No. 7092, Inform. Circ. U. S. Bur. Mines. HARRINGTON, Frank Tandy. The treat- ment of asthma, ix, 112p. pl. 8? Lond., H. K. Lewis & Co., 1936. HARRINGTON, Marie. Nutrition—what has it to do with me? 45p. illust. 8? N. Y., Woman's Press, 1936. HARRINGTON, Mark W. Rainfall and snow of the United States, compiled to the end of 1891, with annual, seasonal, monthly, and other charts. 80p. 4? Wash., Gov. Print. Off., 1894. Forms Bull. Circ U. S. Weather Bur. HARRINGTON, Milton, 1884- Wish- hunting in the unconscious; an analysis of psycho- analysis. 4 p. 1. 189p. 8? N. Y., Macmillan Co., 1934. ---- A biological approach to the problem of abnormal behavior. 459p. 8? Lancaster,- Pa., Sc. Press Print. Co., 1938. HARRIS, Albert Edward. *Ein Beitrag zur Pancreatitis chronica [Bern] 21p. 22cm. Stetten, K. Schahl, 1939. HARRIS, Chapin A., 1806-60. Dictionary of medical terminology, dental surgery, and the collateral sciences. 4. ed., carefully revised and enlarged by Ferdinand J. S. Gorgas. xv, 754p. 8? Phila., Lindsay & Blakiston, 1878. ----A dictionary of dental science; and such words and phrases of the collateral sciences as pertain to the art and practice of dentistry. 6. ed. xi, 662p. 8? Phila., P. Blakiston's Son & Co., 1899. For biography see In Proc Dent. Centen. Celebr. (Maryland Dent, Ass.) 1940, 956; 1019, portr. (J. B. Robinson) HARRIS, Daniel, 1907- Opportunities for medical practice in the United States, in- cluding a rank-order listing of states according to their relative capacity to absorb more phy- sicians. 12 numb. 1. inch tab. 28 x 22cm. [N. Y., 1940] HARRIS, Daniel Thomas. Experimental physiology for medical students; being the re- vised and enlarged ed. of Anrep and Harris' Practical physiology. 2. ed. ix, 248p. illust. pl. diagrs. roy. 8? Lond., J. & A. Churchill, 1934. HARRIS, Edith. See Harris, K., & Harris, E. Minor medical operations. 198p. 19cm. Lond., 1938. HARRIS, Florence LaGank, & HENDERSON, Ruth Adele. Foods, their nutritive, economic and social values, xi, 633p. illust. pl. diagrs. 8? Bost., Little, Brown & Co., 1938. HARRIS, Harold J[erome] 1900- Brucel- losis (undulant fever) clinical and subclinical. xix p. 286p. illust. tab. 2 pl. portr. 24cm. N. Y., P. B. Hoeber [1941] HARRIS 88 HARRIS HARRIS, Henry Albert, 1886- Bone growth in health and disease; the biological principles underlying the clinical, radiological, and histological diagnosis of perversions of growth and disease in the skeleton, xv, 248p. illust. diagrs. rov. 8? Lond., Oxford Univ. Press, 1933. HARRIS, Henry Fauntleroy, 1867-1926. Obituary. J. Am. M. Ass., 1926, 86: 1088. HARRIS, Herbert Elwin, 1860-1941. Obituary. Brit. M. J., 1941, 1: 911. Also Lancet, Lond., 1941, 1: 710. HARRIS, I[saac] 1883- Diet and high blood pressure. 196p. tab. S? Lond., Hogarth Press, 1937. ----ALDRED, Charles Nunn [et al.] High blood pressure. xx, 132p. tab. diagr. S° Lond., H. Milford, 1937. HARRIS, Isham G., 1867-1927. Obituary. J. Am. M. Ass., 1927, 88: 1583. Also Psychiat. Q., 1927, 1: 379-81, portr. HARRIS, James Arthur, 1880-1930, JACK- SON, C. M. [et al.] The measurements of man. vii, 215p. 5 pl. 8? [Minneapolis] Univ. Minne- sota Press, 1930. HARRIS, Jessie Ralph, 1875-1926. Obituary. J. Am. M. Ass., 1926, 86: 1148. HARRIS, John, 1798-1849. Weinberger, B. W. The father of American dental educa- tion; his true place in American dentistry. Dent. Cosmos, 1929, 71: 1074-81. HARRIS, Junius Brainard, 1882- Harris, J. B. Salutation from Junius B. Harris of Sacra- mento, vice-president of the American Medical Association. California West, M., 1938, 48: 393, portr. HARRIS, Kenneth, & HARRIS, Edith. Minor medical operations for senior medical students and recently qualified practitioners, x, 198p. illust. 19cm. Lond., H. K. Lewis & Co., 1938. HARRIS, Leslie Julius, 1898- Vitamins in theory and practice, xix, 240p. illust. portr. diagrs. 21cm. Cambr., Eng., Univ. Press, 1935. Also [3. ed.] xix, 242p. illust. portr. fasc. diagr. 1938. ---- Vitamins and vitamin deficiencies, v.l: Introductory and historical; vitamin B and beri- beri. 204p. illust. 21cm. Phila., P. Blakiston's Son & Co., 1938. HARRIS, Malcolm Lasalle, 1862-1936. Editor of Braun, Heinrich. Local anesthesia. 41 lp. 8? Phila., 1924. For biography see Ann. Surg., 1937, 105: 311, portr. (V. C. David) Also Proc. Inst. M. Chicago, 1936-37, 11: 143, portr. (M. Fishbein) Also Tr. West. Surg. Ass., 1936, 46: 453, portr. (C. U. Collins) HARRIS, Maurice Coleman, 1899- , & FINESILVER, Benjamin. Normal facts in diagnosis, p. 1. 247p. 8? Phila., F. A. Davis Co., 1930. HARRIS, Noel [Gordon] Modern psycho- therapy, vii, 146p. 19cm. [Lond.] J. Bale [1939] See also Gordon, Ronald G., Harris. N. G., & Rees, John R. An introduction to psychological medicine. 386p. 8? Lond 1936. HARRIS, Philander Abbey, 1852-1924. Coe, H. C. Obituary. Tr. Am. Gyn. Soc, 1925, 50: 311, portr. HARRIS, Pickens E., 1891- *Changing conceptions of school discipline [Columbia Cniv 1 3S4p. 8? X. Y., MacMillan Co., 1927. HARRIS, R. W., & SACK, Leonard Shoeten. Medical insurance practice; a work of reference to the medical benefit provisions of the National Health Insurance Acts, xvi, 327p. 8? Lond Sc Press, 1922. Also 2. ed. xii, 347p. 1924 HARRIS, Robert B. See Hinman, R. B., & Harris, R. B. The story of meat. 291p. 20}^cm. Chic, 1939. HARRIS, Robert Lafayette, 1S5S 1927. Obituary. J. Florida M. Ass., 1926 27, 13: 276. HARRIS, Seale, sr., 1870- For portrait see J. M. Ass. Alabama, 1937-38, 7: 420. — & HARRIS, Seale, jr. Clinical pellagra. 4 p. 1. 494p. illust. tab. diagr. pl. 25^cm. S. Louis, C. V. Mosby Co., 1941. HARRIS, Seale, jr, 1900- See Harris, S., & Harris, S., jr. Clinical pellagra. 494p. 25}^cm. S. Louis, 1941. HARRIS, Walter, 1647-1742. Ruhrah, J. [Biography] Am. J. Dis. Child., 1929, 38: 1064-7. HARRIS, Wilfred, 1869- Neuritis and neuralgia, xiv, 418p. 8? Lond., H. Milford, [1926] ---- The facial neuralgias, x, 109p. illust. diagrs. 8° Lond., H. Milford, 1937. ----The morphology of the brachial plexus; with a note on the pectoral muscle and its tendon twist. xviii, 117p. illust. 25^em. Lond., Oxford Univ. Press, 1939. HARRISBURG, Pa. Bureau of Health and Sanitation. Annual report. Harrisb. (1892; 1894; 1912-15; 1924-28) 1893-1929. —-— Health bulletin. Harrisb., v.l, Nos. 1-9, 1915. HARRISBURG, Pa. State Lunatic Hospital. Annual report. Harrisb., 1.-19., 1851-69; 20- 29., 1870-79; 30.-37., 1879/80-1887; 41., 1890-91; 48.-59., 1897/98-1909; 61.-67., 1910/11-1917. ----By-laws. Harrisb., 1879. ----Rules and regulations. Harrisb., 1851. HARRIS County Medical Society. Coole, W. A. The Harris County Medical Society of to- morrow. Med. Rec, Houston, 1940, 34: 399-402, plans. HARRIS Laboratories, Inc. [Tuckahoe, N. Y.] Vitamin deficiency and its treatment. 15p. 23cm. [n. p., 1938] Forms No. 68, Bull. Harris Lab. HARRISON, Archibald Cunningham, 1864- 1926. Biography. Surg. Gyn. Obst., 1937, 65: 118-22, portr.— Obituary. J. Am. M. Ass., 1926, 86: 501. HARRISON, Bede James Michael, 1877- A textbook of roentgenology; the Roentgen ray in diagnosis and treatment, xxvi, 826p. illust. diagr. 8? Bait., W. Wood & Co., 1936. HARRISON, Beverly Drake, 1855-1924. Memorial to Doctor Harrison. Fed. Bull., Chic 1935 21: No. 11, 322. HARRISON, Edward Frank, 1869-1918. [Biography] Pharm. J., Lond., 1941, 92: 144, portr. HARRISON, Gene. Ethics in nursing. 163p pl. 8? S. Louis, C. V. Mosby Co., 1932. HARRISON, Geoffrey Arthur. Chemical methods in clinical medicine, their application and interpretation with the technique of the simple tests, ix, 534p. 2 pl. 8? Lond., J. & A. Churchill, 1930. Also 2. ed. xi, 585p. illust. pl. tab. 1937. HARRISON, George Tucker, 1835-1925. Obituary. Tr. Am. Gyn. Soc, 1926, 51: 297, portr. HARRISON, Glen Henry, 1910- ♦Obser- vations on the complications following 100 cases of cataract extraction [St Louis Univ. Hosp. Group] 13 1. 28cm. [S. Louis] 1939. Typewritten. HARRISON 89 HARROWER HARRISON, James Alexander, 1903- *Immunologic studies in poliomyelitis. 56p. tab. 8? Chic, Univ. Chicago Libr., 1937. HARRISON, Lawrence Whitaker, 1876- The treatment of syphilis; a survey of records from St Thomas's Hospital. 83p. viii. roy. 8? Lond., H. M. Stat. Off., 1929. Forms No. 132, Spec. Rep. Ser., M. Res. Counc. Gr. Britain. ----Syphilis, p.526-626. 24cm. Lond., 1939. In Brit. Encycl. M. Pract. (Rolleston) 1939, 11: - WARD, D. L. C, FERGUSON, T., & RORKE, M. Report on anti-venereal measures in certain Scandinavian countries and Holland. 156p. 8? Lond., H. M. Stat. Off., 1938. Forms No. 83, Rep. Pub. Health & M. Subj. HARRISON, Leonard Vance, 1891- See Mayers, Lewis, & Harrison, Leonard V. The distribu- tion of physicians in the U. S. 197p. 8! N. Y., 1924. ----& GRANT, Pryor McNeill. Youth in the toils, vii, 167p. 8? N. Y., Macmillan, 1938. HARRISON, Paul Wilberforce, 1883- Geiger, A. J. A modern Arabian knight. Med. Econom., 1940-41, 18: No. 5, 46-51, portr. HARRISON, Ross G[ranville] 1870- Portrait, photograph see collection in library. HARRISON, Shelby Millard, 1881- , & EATON, Allen. Welfare problems in New York City which have been studied and reported upon during the period from 1915 through 1925; pre- pared at the request of the Welfare Council for use by the Council and the social agencies of the city, xii, 84p. 8? N. Y., Welfare Counc, 1926. HARRISON, Tinsley Randolph, 1900- Failure of the circulation, xii, 396p. pl. diagrs. 23/2cm. Bait., Williams & Wilkins Co., 1935. Also [2. ed.] xiv, 502p. pl. diagr. 1939. HARRISON Act. See Drug addiction, Dangerous drugs: Laws. HARRISON'S business and general yearbook of South Africa and adjacent territories. 5. issue. 564p. 8? Pietermaritzburg, Natal Witness Ltd., 1929. HARRISSON, Thomas Harnett, 1912- Savage civilisation. 461p. illust. pl. diagrs. map. 8? Lond., V. Gollancz, 1937. HARROP, George Argale, 1890- Diet in disease; sample diets and food lists, ix, 404p. 2 ch. 8? Phila., P. Blakiston's Son & Co. [1930] --- & WINTROBE, Maxwell, M. Poly- cythemia. p.2365-444. 8? N. Y., P. B. Hoeber, 1938. In Handb. Hemat. (Downey, H.) N. Y., 1938, 4: HARROW, Benjamin, 1888- Eminent chemists of our time. 2. ed. xx, 471p. 17 pl. ch. 8? N. Y., D. Van Nostrand Co. [1927] ---- Glands in health and disease, xvi, 275p. pl. 8? N. Y., E. P. Dutton & Co. [1928] ---- Biochemistry for medical, dental and college students. 383p. illust. diagrs. 8? Phila., W. B. Saunders, 1938. ----The same. Textbook of biochemistry. 2. ed., rev. ix, 439p. illust. diagr. 24cm. Phila., W. B. Saunders Co., 1940. See also Lowy, Alexander, & Harrow, Benjamin. An intro- duction to organic chemistry. 3. ed. 412p. 8? N. Y., 1932. ---- & SHERWIN, Carl Paxson, 1885- The chemistry of the hormones, vii, 227p. 8? Bait., Williams & Wilkins Co., 1934. ---- A textbook of biochemistry. 797p. diagrs. 8? Phila., W. B. Saunders Co., 1935. HARROWER, David, 1857-1937. Greene, L. S. Obituary. Tr. Am. Ophth. Soc, 1938, 36: 17, portr.—Holzer, W. F. Obituary. Arch. Ophth., Chic, 1938, 19: 281. HARROWER, Henry Robert, 1883- Practical organotherapy; the internal secretions in general practice. 2. ed. 268p. 8? Glendale, Calif., Harrower Lab., 1920. ---- The endocrines and blood-pressure. 224p. 18? Glendale, Calif., Harrower Lab., 1926. ----The endocrines in gynecology. 256p. 16? Glendale, Calif., Harrower Lab., 1927. ---- The hepatic principle, anabolin, detoxi- cation by the liver and the control of functional hypertension; with a foreword by Ivo Geikie Cobb and an historical introduction by Victor Robinson, xi, 147p. 8? Lond., Bailliere, Tin- dall & Cox, 1927. ----Endocrine diagnostic charts; with other related information. 144p. 8? Glendale, Calif., Harrower Lab. [1929] ----Practical endocrinology. 2 p. 1. 704p. 8? Glendale, Calif., Pioneer Print. Co., 1931. ----Three lectures on endocrinology in everyday practice. 62p. 8? Glendale, Calif., Harrow Lab., 1935. HARROWER, John Gordon, 1890-1936. Obituary. Lancet, Lond., 1936, 1: 975. Also Proc. R. Soc. Edinburgh, 1935-36, 56: 255. HARROWER, Mary Rachel. The psychologist at work; an introduction to experimental psy- chology, xiv, 184p. 8? Lond., K. Paul, Trench, Trubner & Co. [1937] HARRS, Otto, 1910- *Die in den Jahren 1908-33 wegen Magencarcinom ausgefiihrten Operationen und ihre Endresultate [Kiel] 27p. 8? Gutersloh, Thiele, 1935. HARRY, Ralph G. Modern cosmeticology; the principles and practice of modern cosmetics. xiii, 288p. 6 pl. 24cm. N. Y., Chemical Pub. Co., 1940. HARSCH, Eugene. Biochemistry; manual of Dr W. Schuessler's tissue remedies. 139p. tab. 16? Phila., Boericke & Tafel, 1935. HARSCH, Otto, 1906- *Ueber den Ein- fluss von Lavulose auf die Sauerstoffzehrung uberlebenden Gewebes [Munster] 19p. 8? Werne-Lippe, F. Grube, 1935. HARSCH, Walter, 1912- *Versuche am Frosch iiber Hemmung der Exsudatbildung (Adrenalingruppe, Mucilaginosa) 20p. 21%cm. Tub.,B61zle, 1938. HARSCHAR, Irmgard, 1910- *Neues Verfahren zur Fiirbung von Diphtheriebazillen. lOp. 8? Tub., E. Gobel, 1934. HARSHAW, Harold M. *Some relations be- tween fertility and the composition of the diet [Univ. Missouri] 23p. 8? [Columbia, n. pub.] 1926. HARST, van den. Register van verlossingen: [Note: Blank registration book for births; for the use of obstetricians] 27 1. 8? Middelburg, J. C. & W. Altorffer, 1898. HART, Alfred, 1908- *Erbbiologische Untersuchung eines Fades von Niemann-Pick'- scher Krankheit. 12p. 2 ch. 21cm. Wiirzb., P. Scheiner, 1937. HART, Bernard, 1879- The psychology of insanity. 2. ed. ix, 176p. 16? Cambr. [Eng.] Univ. Press, 1914. Also [4. ed.] xxxiv, 176p. 1930. Cambridge Manuals of Science and Literature. ---- Psychopathology; its development and its place in medicine. 4 1. 156p. 8? Cambr., Eng., Univ. Press, 1927. Also [2. ed.] 4 p. 1. 178p. 8? Cambr., Eng. Univ. Press, 1929. HART 90 HARTE HART. ( arl Julius Friedrich August, 1876 1922. Srhaetz, G. Carl Hart. Verh. Deut. path. Ges., 1935, 28: 348- VI. HART, Charles 1". Food cure for constipation and resultant diseases. 32p. 32? Phila. [n. pub] 1S95. HART, C[harles] P[orter] 1827 Reper- tory to the new remedies; based upon, and de- signed to accompany Hale's special symptoma- tology and therapeutics, viii, 199p. 8? X. l., Boeri'cke & Tafel, 1876. ---- Homoeopathic ophthalmic practice; a systematic treatise on diseases of the eye; for the use of general practitioners and students, vii, 336p S° Detr., E. A. Lodge, 1S78. HART, Clarence Dunbar, 1895 Dr Clarence Dunbar Hart, councillor of the 12th district. J. Michigan M. Soc, 1938, 37: 1003, portr. HART, Ella Brockhauser. See Hart, H. X.. & Hart, E. B. Personality and the family. Rev. & enl. ed. 526p. 22Hcm. Bost., 1941. HART [Mrs] Ernest. Dishes for diabetics. 44p. 12? Lond., J. Bale, Sons & Danielsson, 1922. HART, Hornell Norris, 1888- Differ- ential fecundity in Iowa. 39p. 8? Iowa Citv, Univ. Iowa, 1922. Univ. Iowa Stud, in Child Welfare, v.2, No. 2. ---- A test of social attitudes and interests. 40p. 8? Iowa Citv, Univ. Iowa, 1923. Univ. Iowa Stud. Child Welfare, v.2. No. 4. ----& HART, Ella Brockhauser. Personality and the family. Rev. & enl. ed. xiii, 526p. tab. diagr. 22.4cm. Bost., D. C. Heath & Co. [1941] *Ueber Borna, R. Great Methuen & HART, Irma Magda, 1903 Ureter fissus [Miinchen] v, 31p. Xoske, 1929. HART, Ivor Blashka, 1889- physicists. vi, 137p. 16? Lond. Co., 1927. HART, Joseph, 1907- *Milieu confine et milieu surpresse dans les abris contre les gaz de combat. 45p. 8? Par., M. Vign6, 1936. HART, Lloyd Commodore, 1892- Our baby's care and feeding. 4 p. 1. 130p.; [7]p. illust. 254cm. [Lansing, Educ. Pub. Co., 1939] HART, P[hilip Montagu] D'Arcy. The value of tuberculin tests in man; with special reference to the intracutaneous test. 136p., ix. 8? Lond., H. M. Stat. Off., 1931. Forms No. 164, Spec. Rep. M. Res. Counc. Gr. Britain. ---- & WRIGHT, G. Payling. Tuberculosis and social conditions in England, with special reference to young adults (a statistical study) vii, 165p. inch tab. diagr. 25cm. Lond., Nat. Ass. Prev. Tuberc, 1939. HART, Theodore Stuart, 1869- Taking care of your heart. 3 p. 1. 72p. 16? N. Y., Funk & Wagnalls, 1924. Also Rev. ed. ix, HOp. [1937] HART, Trusten Mitchell, 1881-1934. Obituary. California West. M., 1934, 41: 135. HART, Walter Morris, 1872- Editor of Shakespeare, William. The tragedy of Hamlet prince of Denmark. 262p. 16? X. Y. [1917] HART, William Lee, 1881- See United States Army. American Expeditionary Force. Base Hospital No. 53. History. 63p. 8! Langres, 1919. HARTARD, Ludwig, 1908- *Osteomye- litis der Kiefer. 16p. 8° Heidelb [n. pub.] 1934 HARTE, Bret, 1836-1902. Bragman. L. J. The medical wisdom of Bret Harte Ann M. Hist., 1934, n. ser., 6: 180-5. HARTE, Richard Hickman, 1S55 1925. Ashhurst. A. P. C. Master surgeons of America. Surg. Gyn. Obst., 1929, 48: 135-7, portr.—Obituary. J. Am. M. Ass., 1925, 85: 1827. HARTELT, Alfons [Josef Alois] 1909- *Der Schenkelhalsbruch und seine Behandlung in der chirurgischen Universitalsklinik zu (ircifs- wald. 40p. 22j2cm. Greifsw., H. Adler, 193S. HARTEN, Heinrich Christian, 1850-1933. Norrie, G. [Obituary] Milita;rlaegen, 1933, 39: 122. HARTEN, Ludolf, 1901- *Ueber die Behandlungserfolge von 23 Zungenkarzinomen der Gottinger Chirurgischen Klinik vom Jahre 1912-27 [Gottingen] 26p. 2 pl. 8? Borna, Xoske, 1930. HARTENFELS, Helmuth [Eugen Heinz] 189S *Die zentrale Datamruptur [Giessen] 12p. 4 1. 8? Hagen, G. Butz, 1922. HARTENSTEIN, Henry, 1911- *Die Bedeutung der Harnsaure fiir die Entstehung der Regenbogenhaut- und Lederhautentziindung [Munchen] 23p. 21cm. Gunzburg, K. Mayer, 1937. HARTER, Elmer E., jr. Pennsylvania food laws. 73p. 8? Phila., Dunlap Print Co. [1939] Forms No. 1, v.22, Pennsylvania Dep. Agr. HARTER, Oskar [Hermann] 1913- *Bei- trag zur Frage der aktiven Beteiligung des Ekto- und Mesoderms bei der Formgestaltung des Zahnkeimes. 21p. 8? Wiirzb., Gebr. Mem- minger, 1936. HARTERTIA. Sec Spiruridae. HARTFORD, Conn. Asylum at Walnut Hill [*1875] Annual report of the officers and super- intendent. Hartford, 1.-4., 1874/75-1877/78. HARTFORD, Conn. Board of Health. An- nual reports. Hartford, 1.-50., 1885-1935. —— Cancer in Hartford; a statistical analysis, 1920-36. 60p. 23cm. Hartford, Bd Health, 1938. ----Health bulletin. Hartford, v.l, 1936- HARTFORD, Conn. Hospital Training School for Nurses. Annual report. Hartford, 1.-26., 1877-1903. In Hartford Hospital. Annual reports. HARTFORD, Conn. Neuro-Psychiatric Insti- tute. Annual report. Hartford, 63.-110., 1886- 1934. HARTFORD, Conn. Old Peoples Home. Annual report, Hartford, 1.-19., 1884-1903. In Hartford Hospital. Annual reports. HARTFORD, Conn. Retreat for the Insane [*1824] Report of the directors. Hartford, 1823; 3., 1826-27; 7., 1830-31; 10., 1833-34; 1839-81; 52.-62., 1881/82-1885/86; 64.-91., 1887/88-1914- 15; 109., 1932-33. ---- Letters on the construction of the by- laws. Hartford, 1873. ---- Semi-centennial anniversary. Hartford (1873) 1876. HARTFORD, Conn. State Veterinary Surgeon. Report on the contagious diseases of domestic animals (N. Cressy) Hartford, 1.-4., 1871-74 HARTFORD, Conn. Walnut Lodge Hospital. Annual report of the superintendent and phy- sician. Hartford, 1893-96; 1898-1900. HARTFORD, Conn. See also Connecticut, U. S. A. Foote F. M West Hartford health goes forward. Con- necticut Health Bull., 1941, 55: 60.—Professional staff of the Hartford Neuro-psychiatric Institute of the Hartford Retreat. J. Connecticut M. Soc, 1938, 2: 380. HARTFORD 91 HARTLEY HARTFORD Hospital [Conn.] Annual reports of the executive committee to the directors. Hartford, 1.-48., 1855-1903. HARTH, Ernst, 1912- *Untersuchungen iiber die Veranderung des Fleisches unter ver- schiedenen Aufbewahrungsbedingungen mit be- sonderer Berucksichtigung der pH-Zahl. 31p. 8? Giessen, E. Seibert, 1936. HARTH, Gertrud, 1904- *Biometrische Untersuchungen iiber die Dimensionen des Xormalgebisses in verschiedenen Lebensaltern; intramaxillare Beziehungen [Bonn] p. 1537-63. 8? Berl., J. Springer, 1930. Also Deut. Mschr. Zahnh., 1930, 48: HARTIG, Heinz, 1910- *Ein fahrbares Untergesteli fiir die Heerestrage 34 [Kiel] 15p. 234cm. Lengerich, Lengerich. Dr., 1938. HARTIG, Michael, 1907- *Ueber Neubil- dungen an der Zunge bei Tieren. 24p. 8? Gies- sen [n. pub.] 1934. HARTING, Herbert [Friedrich Karl] 1909- *Stomatitis gravis bei Nephritis und Uramie. 17p. 8? Rostock, C. Hinstorff, 1934. HARTING, Kurt, 1905- *Ueber die feinere Innervation der Tube. p.544-60. 8? Bonn [n. pub., 1933] Also Zschr. Zellforsch., 1929, 9: HARTING, Tilmann, 1909- *Ein Beitrag zur Beisserpokelung mit hoheren Lakemengen [Giessen] 39p. 8? Speyer, Pilger, 1936. HARTINGER, Edward T. The opticians' dispensing manual. 4 p. 1. 192p. illust. diagrs. 194cm. N. Y. [1932] Also 3. ed. v, 226p. illust. diagr. [1940] HARTJE, Hans [Carl] 1883- ♦Experi- mentelle Untersuchungen iiber das Natrium kakodylicum an Meerschweinchen, Kaninchen, Katzen und Hunden, sowie dessen klinisch- therapeutische Verwendbarkeit bei Krankheiten der Hunde [Bern] 59p. 8? Borna, R. Noske, 1909. HARTJE, Raimund, 1905- *Verglei- chende Untersuchungen alterer und moderner Magenuntersuchungsmethoden. 19p. 8? Berl. [n. pub.] 1931. HARTL, Hans, 1892- *Ueber die Bezie- hung der Zahnkronenlange zur Wurzellange; eine Korrelationstheoretische Untersuchung bei Zahnen des menschlichen Unterkiefers. 14p. 4 tab. 8? Munch., M. Schmidt & Sonne, 1932. HARTLAND, Edwin Sidney, 1848-1927. Myres, J. L. Obituary. Man, Lond., 1927, 27: 143-7.— Obituary. Nature, Lond., 1927, 119: 933. HARTLAUB, Gustav Friedrich, 1884- Der Genius im Kinde, ein Versuch iiber die zeichnerische Anlage des Kindes. 2. Aufl. 229p. pl. roy. 8? Bresl., F. Hirt, 1930. HARTLEB, Hans Otto, 1907- *Experi- mentelle und klinische Untersuchungen zur Frage der peroralen Diabetesbehandlung mit insulin- ahnlichen pflanzlichen Stoffen (Phaseolan) [Bres- lau] 12p. 8? Miinch., J. F. Lehmann, 1932. HARTLEBEN, Hans, & SCHAD, Gustav. Innere Medizin und Hygiene. 2. Aufl. 167p. 8? Miinch., J. F. Lehmann [1936] HARTLEY, David, 1705-57. Langdon-Brown, W. David Hartley; physician and phi- losopher. Proc. R. Soc M., Lond., 1940-41, 34: 233-9. HARTLEY, Francis William, 1865-1929. Obituary. Brit. M. J., 1929, 1: 180. HARTLEY, John Norman Jackson. See Cathcart, Charles W., & Hartley, J. N. J. Requisites and methods in surgery for the use of students, house surgeons and general practitioner. 476p. 12! Edinb., 1928. HARTLEY, Percival Horton-Smith, 1867- See also Powell. Richard D., & Hartley, Percival H. S. On diseases of the lungs and pleurae. 6. ed. 798p. 8? Lond., 1921. ----& ALDRIDGE, Harold Richard. Johannes de Mirfeld of St Bartholomew's, Smithfield; his life and works, xvi, 191p. facs. 8? Cambr., Univ. Press, 1936. HARTLEY, Percival Horton-Smith, WING- FIELD, R. C, & THOMPSON, J. H. R. An inquiry into the after-histories of patients treated at the Brompton Hospital sanatorium at Frimley, during the years 1905-14. 50p. 8? Lond., H. M. S. O., 1924. Forms No. 85, Spec. Rep. Ser. Gr. Brit. Privy Counc. Med Res. Counc. HARTLIEB, Adam, 1901- *Beitrag zur Histologic der Wurzelgranulome [Wurzburg] 18p. 8? Ochsenfurt, Fritz & Rappert, 1932. HARTLMAIER, Karl, 1913- *Ueber die Entstehung der Lehre von den neuritischen Dermatosen rMiinchen] 36p. 8? Bleicherode, C. Nieft, 1937. HARTMAN, Arlett B., 1896-1941. Obituary. Mil. Surgeon, 1941, 88: 697. HARTMAN, Carl Gottfried, 1879- Time of ovulation in women; a study on the fertile period in the menstrual cycle, x, 226p. illust. diagrs. 8? Bait., Williams & Wilkins Co., 1936. ----& STRAUS, William Louis. The anatomy of the rhesus monkey (Macaca mulatta) ix, 383p. illust. pl. diagrs. 8? Bait., Williams & Wilkins Co., 1933. HARTMAN, Frank Alexander, 1884- , & BLATZ, W. E. Studies in the regeneration of denervated mammalian muscle. 19p. 8? Otta- wa, T. Mulvey, 1920. HARTMAN, George W., 1904- Pre- cision and accuracy [Columbia Univ.] 42p. 8? N. Y. [n. pub.] 1928. Also Arch. Psychol., No. 100. HARTMAN, Gerhard Johan Casper, 1873- 1937. Wilde, P. A. de [Obituary] Ned. tschr. geneesk., 1937, 81: 1768, portr. HARTMAN, Leroy Leo. The teeth and the mouth. 5 p. 1. 93p. 12? N. Y., D. Appleton & Co., 1927. HARTMAN, Olga, 1900- New species of polychaetous annelids of the family Nereidae from California, p.467-80. illust. 8? Wash., Gov. Print. Off., 1936. Forms No. 2294, Proc. U. S. Nat. Mus. ---- Annotated list of the types of poly- chaetous annelids in the Museum of Comparative Zoology. 31p. 3 pl. 8? Cambridge, Mass. [n. pub.l 1938. Forms No. 1, v.85, Bull. Mus. Comp. Zool. Harvard. ----Review of the annelid worms of the family Nephtyidae from the Northeast Pacific, with descriptions of 5 new species, p. 143-58. 8? Wash., Gov. Print. Off., 1938. Forms No. 3034, v.85, Proc. U. S. Nat. Mus. -—— The types of the polychaete worms of the families Polynoidae and Polyodontidae in the United States National Museum and the descrip- tion of a new genus, p. 107-34. 8? Wash., Gov. Print. Off., 1938. Forms No. 3046, v.86, Proc. U. S. Nat. Mus. •—■— The polychaetous annelids collected on the Presidential Cruise of 1938. 22p. 8? Wash., Gov. Print. Off., 1939. Forms No. 13, v.98, Smithson. Misc. Collect. HARTMAN, Robert James, 1906- Col- loid chemistry. xxviii, 556p. illust. diagr. 24cm. Bost., Houghton Mifflin Co. [1939] HARTMANELLA 92 HARTMANN HARTMANELLA. See under Amebidae. HARTMANN. Adele Auguste Karoline, 1881- See Benninghoff. A , Hartmann. A. [et al.] Blutgefass- und LvmphgcfasBapparat.Atmungsapparat [&c] 584p. 8? Berl., 1930. HARTMANN, Aloys, 1910- *Experi- mentelle Untersuchungen iiber gegenseitige Be- tinflussungen von Adrenalin und Diastase, gemesson an ihrer hypeiKlykaemisierenden Kraft am lebenden Tier [Munster] 16p. 21cm. Bielefeld, Bever & Hausknccht, 1938. HARTMANN. Arthur, 1849-1931. Denker, A. Nekrolog. Arch. Ohr. &c. Heilk., 1931, 130: p. i—viii.—Korner, O. Nekrolog. Zschr. Hals &c Heilk., 1931-32, 30: p. i.—Zarniko, C. [Biography] Arch. Ohr. &c. Heilk., 1929, 120: p. i-vi. HARTMANN, August, 1904- *Ueber Ernahrung, mit besonderer Berucksichtigung des aus dem Auslande eingefiihrten Obstes und Gemuses. 26p. S? Tiib., E. Gobel, 1931. HARTMANN, Curt, 1904- *Ueber branchiogene Geschwulste an Hand zweier eigener bemerkenswerter Fade [Heidelberg] 21p. 8? Xordenham, W. Boning, 1931. HARTMANN, Edward. La radiographic en ophtalmologie; atlas clinique. 2 1 [2] 272p. illust. fol. Par., Masson & cie, 1936. HARTMANN, Egon, 1909- *Die Dacryo- cystorrhinostomien nach Toti der Giessener Uni- versitats-Augenklinik aus den Jahren 1930-35 [Giessen] 16p. 22V'.cm. Wiirzb., K. Roll, 1935. HARTMANN, Emil, 1897- *Ueber die Einteilung der myeloisch-leukamisehen Erkran- kungen der Haut vom dermatologisch-klinischen Gesichtspunkt [Frankfurt] 20p. 8? Berl., S. Karger, 1926. Also Derm. Zschr., 1926, 49: 52-67. HARTMANN, Erich [August Ludwig Hans] 1910- ^Untersuchungen iiber die Desin- fektion mit Zephirol unter besonderer Beriick- sichtigung der Desinfektion von Rasierpinseln und Biirsten [Munster] 22p. 8? Quakenbriick, R. Kleinert, 1936. HARTMANN, Ernst, 1907- *Ueber Reiter'sche Erkrankung in Anlehnung an zwei neue Falle. 16p. 8? Marb., J. Hamel, 1933. HARTMANN, Ernst, 1910- *Ueber Ver- anderungen des Blutbildes und iiber Blutungen bei der Goldtherapie [Munchen] 19p. 8? Bottrop, W. Postberg, 1937. HARTMANN, Eugen, 1907- *Der Lupus erythematodes der Mundschleimhaut [Heidel- berg] 40p. 8? Walldorf, F. Lamade, 1930. HARTMANN, Franz, & WACHTELBORN, Karl. Die Medizin des Theophrastus Parazelsus von Hohenheim; vom theosophischen Stand- punkte betrachtet. 2. Aufl. 3 p. 1. vii-xvi, 263p. 8? Lpz., Theosophisches Verlag [192?] HARTMANN, Friedrich Wilhelm, 1895- *Ergebnisse der Xachuntersuchung von Patienten mit Thyreotoxikose im Hinblick auf Heilerfolg und Arbeitsfahigkeit. 19p. 22y2cm. Giessen, E. Seibert, 1937. HARTMANN, Fritz, 1871-1937. Ueber das Denken in der klinischen Medizin: 1. Teil. Theoretisches zu den Voraussetzungen fur das Denken in der klinischen Medizin. xiv p. 238p 97 illust. 2pl. 4? Graz, Leuschner & Lubensky, 1931. J' For biography see Wien. klin. Wschr., 1937, 50: 546 (O Kauders) HARTMANN, Georg [Bernhard Maria] 1901- *Kiinisch-bakteriologisehe Untersuchun- gen uber die Sterilitat des Zahninnern nach der Devitalisation der Pulpa mit Arsenik. 27p. 2 1. S? Bresl., (). Gutsmann, 1929. HARTMANN, Hans. Gesunde Kinder; das Lebenswerk Adalbert Czernys. 327j). portr. S? Berl., K. Siegismund, 193S. HARTMANN, Hans, 1S95- *Weiterc Versuche zur Form- und Raumbestandigkeit von Einbettungsmassen. 39p. diagr. 8? Bresl., A. Schreiber, 1933. HARTMANN, Hans, 1908-1937. *Experi- mentell-physiologische Untersuchungen auf der deutschen Himalaya-Expedition 1931 [Wurz- burg] p.391-404. 8? Miinch., J. F. Lehmann [1932] Also Zschr. Biol., 1933, 93: For biography see Deut. med. Wschr., 1937, 63: 138(1 (H. Rein) Also Erg. Physiol., 1937, 39: 408-12 (A. von Mun,Il i HARTMANN, Hans, 1910- *Ueber Fruh- geburten [Rostock] 17p. 8? Altenkirchen, W. Dieckmann, 1935. HARTMANN, Hans, 1910- *Die Haufig- keit der Hyperthyreosen an der II. Medizinischen Klinik der Universitat Munchen in den Jahren 1924-34 [Munchen] 24p. 8? Speyer, Pilger, 1936. HARTMANN, Henri Albert Charles Antoine, 1860- Diagnostic des principaux cancers; avec la collaboration de MM. Bensaude, Berard fetal.] p. 1. 61p. 8? Par., Masson & cie, 1927. ----Chirurgie du rectum. 3 p. 1. 398p. 8? Par., Masson & cie, 1931. ---- Livre jubilaire offert au Professeur Hart- mann par ses amis et ses Aleves. 2 p. 1. xxxvi, 679p. illust. portr. 4? Par., Masson & cie, 1932. ---- Gyn6cologie ope>atoire. 2. 4>d. 2 1. 585p. illust. 8? Par., Masson & cie, 1933. See also Turck Foundation Papers. The biological reactions of tissue extracts. 3 1. 8? [n. p.] 1922. HARTMANN, Hilde, 1905- *Zur Frage der Epulis unter besonderer Berucksichtigung des chronischen Reizes. 24p. 8? Gott., R. Erbs & K. Meisel, 1935. HARTMANN, Horst, 1913- Verglei- chende Untersuchungen fiber die Brauchbarkeit der fiir die Typendifferenzierung der Diphtherie- bazillen angegebenen Spezialnahrbbden [Frank- furt] 15p. 8? Gelnhausen, F. W. Kalbfleisch, 1938. HARTMANN,Jacob. Modernbaby; or.Theart of nursing and raising children; a popular treatise. 90p. 12? N. Y, E. H. Blinn & Co., 1881. HARTMANN, Jakob, 1903- *Ueber sogenannte unklare Fieberzustande. 30p. 8? [Bonn, n. pub.] 1926. HARTMANN, Jakob, 1907- *Die Bezie- hungen zwischen Cystenmamma und Mamma- carcinom. 83p. 22>km. Zur., Gebr. Leemann & Co., 1937. HARTMANN, Joachim, 1903- *Ueber die tabische Arthropathie des Hiiftgelenks. 27p. 8? Bresl. [n. pub.] 1929. HARTMANN, Josef, 1906- *Blutsen- kungsgeschwindigkeit und Reaktion nach Costa bei Tuberkulose. 34p. 8? Marb., J. Hamel, 1931. HARTMANN, Josef, 1912- *Ueber den Einfluss von Alkali- und Erdalkalisalzen auf die Oxydation der Bernsteinsaure [Munster] 28p. 21cm. Werne a.rd. Lippe, F/Grube, 1936. HARTMANN, Joseph Al. *De intro-retro- versione, methodo nova operationis radicalis herniae inguinalis. 32p. 21cm. Wien, C. Ueber- reuter, 1840. HARTMANN 93 HARTMANN HARTMANN, Jiirgen, 1907- *Verglei- chende Untersuchungen der Meinicke-Mikro- Klarungs-Reaktion mit der Wassermannschen Reaktion an 2,000 Seren. 26p. 8? Rostock, Winterberg, 1931. HARTMANN, Karl, 1901- *Bekampfung der Tollwut. 29p. 8? Tiib., E. Gobel, 1927. HARTMANN, Karl, 1909- *Der Einfluss der Innendruckerhohung des isolierten Uterus auf die Wirkung der Wehenmittel. 24p. 8? Weende, E. Pieper, 1935. HARTMANN [Karlfried Werner] Heino, 1907- *Beitrag zur Klinik und chirurgischen Be- handlung des Magencarcinoms (nach den Erfah- rungen bei 726 Fallen der Chirurgischen Universi- tats-Klinik zu Giessen aus den Jahren 1905-35) 32p. 8? Giessen, W. Herr, 1937. HARTMANN, Karl Giinter, 1908- *Ueber die Wirkung von Alanin bei eiweissfreier Ernah- rung auf den Zwischenstoffwechsel. 13p. 8? Berl. [n. pub.] 1937. HARTMANN, K[arl] J[ulius] 1893- Das Wesen der affektfreien qualitativen Bedeutungs- gefiihle; eine Untersuchung iiber den Stand des Gefuhlsproblems. 120p. 8? Berl., S. Karger, 1926. Forms Heft 39, Abh. Neur. Psychiat. HARTMANN, Klaus, 1909- *Kann sich der Mensch durch Speisequarkgenuss mit Bang- bakterien infizieren? 27p. 8? Bresl. [n. pub.] 1933 HARTMANN, Konrad, 1853-1927. Schiele, E. Nekrolog. Gesundh. Ingenieur, 1928, 51: 65. HARTMANN, Kurt H[ellmut] 1913- *Beitrag zur Pathogenese des allgemein verbrei- teten Emphysems unter Berucksichtigung eines solchen Fades im Verlauf einer miliaren Broncho- pneumonie bei Pertussis [Kiel] 23p. 23}^cm. Ulm-Donau, K. Hohn, 1936. HARTMANN, Max, 1876- Praktikum der Protozoologie. 4. Aufl. viii, 146p. 8? Jena, G. Fischer, 1921. Forms 2. Teil Prakt. Bakt. Protozool. (Kisskalt & Hartmann) ----Allgemeine Biologie; eine Einfuhrung in die Lehre vom Leben. 2v. vi, 756p. paged consec. 8? Jena, G. Fischer, 1925- ----P^ortpflanzung und Befruchtung als Grundlage der Vererbung. 2 p. 1. 103p. illust. diagrs. roy. 8° Berl., Gebr. Borntraeger, 1929. Forms (A) Bd 1. Handb. Vererbungswiss. (E. Baur & M. Hartmann) ---- Verteilung, Bestimmung und Vererbung des Geschlechts bei den Protisten und Thallophy- ten. 2 p. 1. 115p. illust. diagrs. roy. 8? Berl., Geb. Borntraeger, 1929. Forms (E) of Bd 2, Handb. Vererbungswiss. (E. Baur & M. Hartmann) ■--- Geschlecht und Geschlechtsbestimmung im Tier- und Pflanzenreich. HOp. illust. 16cm. Berl., W. de Gruyter & Co., 1939. Also editor of Berichte iiber die wissenschaftliche Biologie. Berl., v.l, 1926- Also editor of Handbuch der Vererbungs- wissenschaft. 20v. roy. 8! Berl., 1927-34. HARTMANN, Oskar. See Unglehrt, Hans, & Hartmann, Oskar. Arzneiliche Massage. 199p. 8? Stuttg. [1935] HARTMANN, Otto Julius. Erde und Kosmos im Leben des Menschen, der Naturreiche, Jahres- zeiten und Elemente. 4 p. 1. 409p. illust. 23cm. Frankf. a. M., V. Klosterman [1938] HARTMANN, Otto [Karl Franz] 1908- *Gicht und Rheumatismus; pathologisch-anato- mische Untersuchungen [Leipzig] 28p. 23^cm. [Zeulenroda, A. Oberreuter, 1936] HARTMANN, Richard, 1904- *Erfah- rungen mit der Pneumothoraxbehandlung ein- seitiger Lungenerkrankungen an der Lungen- fursorge Erlangen [Erlangen] 22p. 8? Forch- heim, F. A. Streit, 1931. HARTMANN [Richard] Giinter, 1911- *Die chronisch-deformierenden Gelenkerkrankun- gen in lhrer versicherungsrechtlichen Bedeutune 43p. 8? Borna, R. Noseke, 1937. HARTMANN, Siegfried, 1908- *Ueber zahnarztliches Schleifen und Polieren, mit be- sonderer Erorterung der Natur des Schleif- und Poherprozesses [Munchen] 60p. 8? Lands- berg a. Lech, M. Neumeyer, 1932 HARTMANN, Ulrich, 1913- *Beitrage zur Khnik der Endometriose; unter besonderer Berucksichtigung des Krankengutes der Uni- versitatsfrauenklinik zu Leipzig in den Jahren 1934-36. 51p. 8? Lpz., A. Edelmann, 1937. HARTMANN, Walter, 1899- *Sind die Riesenzellen in der Epulis Endknospen von Gefassen? 24p. 2 pl. 8? Greifsw., H. Adler, 1929. HARTMANN, Walter, 1905- *Die Wir- kung der Adenosinphosphorsaure im Elektro- kardiogramm. p.424-46. 8? Berl., 1932. Also Zschr. klin. Med., 1932, 121: HARTMANN, Werner, 1904- *Ueber das Verschwinden der blutdrucksteigernden Wir- kung der Hypophyse im Korper [Freiburg i. B.] lip. 8? Lpz., F. C. W. Vogel, 1930. Also Arch. exp. Path., Berl., 1930, 154: HARTMANN, Werner, 1909- *Indika- tionsanderungen der deutschen Bader in den letzten fiinfzig Jahren. 32p. 8? Bonn, Kollen- Verlag, 1934. HARTMANN, Werner, 1909- *Sub- cutane Berstungsrupturen des Dunndarmes. 59p. 23cm. Berl., R. Pfau, 1937. See also Goldhahn, R., & Hartmann, W. Chirurgie und Recht. 227p. 22Mcm. Stuttg., 1937. HARTMUTH, Ludwig, 1908- *Ueber die in den Jahren 1925-29 an der Wiirzburger Uni- versitatsaugenklinik beobachteten Falle von Optikusatrophie infolge Schadelbasisfraktur. 20p. 8? Wurzb., G. Schonlein, 1934. HARTNACK, Friedrich Wilhelm, 1911- *Erfolge der Therapie bei Netzhautablosung [Munster] 92p. 22cm. Diisseld., G. H. Nolte, 1936. HARTNACK, Hans Gunther, 1910- *Versuche iiber Anasthesierung der Laryngo- trachealschleimhaut mittels Inhalation von Pantocain-Losungen [Konigsberg] 15p. 8? Lengerich, Handelsdr., 1936. HARTNACK, Hugo, 1888- Two hundred and two common household pests of North Ameri- ca. 319p. illust. 20^cm. Chic, Hartnack Pub. Co., 1939. HARTNER, Linda, 1905- *Ueber die Ausscheidung von Ammoniak und Aminosauren nach Operationen [Freiberg] 34p. 6 ch. 8? Walldorf, F. Lamade, 1930. HARTOCH, Werner, 1902- *Die Merk- male der sogenannten Dystrophia adiposo- genitalis. p.561-604. Berl., J. Springer, 1928. Also Virchow's Arch., 1928-29. 270: H ARTOG JAGER, Evert William den. *Ziekte en sterfte onder de arbeiders bij de steen-kolen- mijnen te Beraoe. 4 p. 1. 97p. 4 pl. 4 ch. map. roy. 8? Amst. [n. pub.] 1924. HARTRIDGE, Gustavus, 1849-1923. The refraction of the eye, a manual for students. 13. ed. xiv, 271p. illust. pl. diagr. 19cm. Lond., J. & A. Churchill, 1905. HARTRIDGE 94 HARTUNG HARTRIDGE. Hamilton, 1SS6- See Starling. 1 inest H.] Principles of human physiology. 5. ed. K'.i'ip. s Und., 1930. Also Evans, Charles A. L., & Hartridgc. Hnnuhmi. Starling's principles of humim ph\ si- ology. 7. ed. Hi'.n.p. 8? Phila., 1936. Also editor cf Bain- bridge, I'riincb <\rthur, & Menzies, James Acworth. Essentials <>f ph>-inlng_\ 7. t-.l. x, 583 [32]p. 8? Lond., 1931. Also 8. ed." 651p. 8? Lond. [1936] --- & HAYNES, F. Histology for medical students, x [2] 369 [30]p. 8? Lond., H. Milford, 1930. HARTSHORNE, Edward. Sec Taylor. Alfred S. Medical jurisprudence. 3. ed. 621p. 8? l'hila.. 1853 HARTSHORNE, Henry, 1823-97. Essentials of the principles and practice of medicine. 5. ed. xii, 669p. illust. 8? Phila., H. C. Lea's Son, 1881. ---- Practical household physician; a cyclo- pedia of family medicine, surgery, nursing and hygiene for daily use in the preservation of health and care of the sick and injured, xxxi, 971p. 8? Phila., J. C. Winston, 1891. HARTSTEIN, Edward, 1910- *Wirkung von Digitalispraparaten auf Kreislauf und Lei- stungsfahigkeit beim normalen. 16p. 23cm. Lpz., A. Teicher, 1936. HARTT, Charles Frederic, 1840-78. Naturalist and explorer; from a woodcut engraving of a photograph. Rep. U. S. Nat. Mus. (1897) 1901, pt 2, pl. 41. HARTUNG, Albrecht, 1901- *Zur Thera- pie der primiiren Pyelitis und Cystopvelitis. 24p. 8? Berl., J. Sittenfeld, 1926. HARTUNG, Armin, 1909- *Zur Frage der Serumbehandlung der eitrigen Peritonitis nach Appendicitis. 22p. 21cm. Erlangen, K. Dores, 1938. HARTUNG, Artur, 1909- *Ein Fall von perforierender Kupfersplitterverletzung mit nach- folgender svmpathischer Ophthalmic 18p. 21cm. Heidelb., Winter, 1936. HARTUNG, Bernhard, 1904- *Ueber die Ursachen genitaler Blutungen in der Menopause [Freiburg] 26p. 8? Oschatz, F. Oldecops, 1931. HARTUNG, Carl, 1906- *Bericht iiber die Erfolge in der Gallenchirurgie in den Jahren 1926-31. 32p. 8° Kiel [n. pub.] 1932. HARTUNG, Christa, 1900- *Eczema vaccinatum [Leipzig] 47p. 8? [Zeulenroda, A. Oberreuter] 1927. HARTUNG, Elly [Luise Gertrud, geb. Matzke] 1898- *Ueber Knollenblatterschwammver- giftung (an Hand von dreizehn klinisch be- obachteten Fallen) [Berlin] 45p. 8? Charlot- tenb., Gebr. Hoffmann, 1927. HARTUNG, Erich, 1910- *Beitrag zur Klinik und Behandlung der Geschwiilste der Seitenkammern des Gehirns. 20p. 8? Wiirzb., R. Mayr, 1935. HARTUNG, Hanns, 1901- *Ueber drei familiare Falle von Tritanomalie; mit 1 Stamm- baum [Freiburg i. B.] 16p. 8? Stuttg., F. Krais, 1926. HARTUNG, Henry Hall, 1875- Barton first-aid text-book; a manual for the student in first aid. 82p. 16? Bost., N. England First- Aid Ass., 1904. ---- First aid to the injured. 132p. 16? Bo«t., Boston Soc. of Instr. First Aid, 1909. HARTUNG, Heinz, 1910- *Statistische Untersuchungen iiber die Angina Plaut-Vincenti fur die Jahre 1936 und 1937 [Berlin] 27p. 21cm. Zeulenroda, B. Sporn, 1938. HARTUNG, Joachim, 1908- *Ueber Poikilodermia vascularis atrophicans. 49p 8° Berl. [n. pub.] 1935. HARTING. Kurt Gustav Willi, 1906-■ ♦Untersuchungen uber die haemolytischen Eigen- schaften des Liquor cer»brospinalis [Leipzig] 15p. 8? Zeulenroda, A. Oberreuter, 1932. HARTWEG, Norman, 1904- , & OLIVER, James A. A contribution to the herpetology of the Isthmus of Tehuantepec; 3 new snakes from the Pacific slope. 8p. pl. 8? Ann Arb., Univ. Michigan Press, 1938. Forms No. 390, Occas. Papers Univ. Michigan Mus. Zool. ---- The same, pt 4. 31p. 25^cm. Ann Arb., Univ. Michigan Press, 1940. Fcrms No. 47, Misc. Pub. Univ. Michigan Mus. Zool. HARTWELL, Henry Ameroy, 1874- What's wrong with me? ix, 246p. 19.'-cm. [Garden Citv, N. Y., Print. Country Life Press] 1938. ---- The living Aesculapius [poem] p. 1. 15p. 20#cm. [n. p., 19-?1 HARTWELL, John Augustus, 1869-1940. [Obituary] J. Am. M. Ass., 1940, 115: 2296. HARTWICH, Alexander. Praktikum der kleinen Sportverletzungen. 3p.; 130p. illust. 8? Wien, W. Maudrich, 1935. HARTWICH, Carl Eugen Gottfried Victor, 1851-? [Biography] In Gallerie hervorrag. Ther. Pharm. Gegenw., Geneve, 1897, 245-7, portr. HARTWICH, Josef, 1906- *Untersuchun- gen iiber Metallurzement. 12p. 8? Wiirzb., K. Roll, 1933. HARTWIG. Spccielle Chirurgie [miscellaneous notes by Moritz Leo-Wolf] 357p. 4? Berl., 1823—24 HARTWIG, Hans [Martin Friedrich] 1903- Die Osteomyelitis des Stirnbeins und ihre Beziehungen zu Stirnhohleneiterungen. 20p. 8? Rostock, W. H. Winterberg, 1927. HARTWIG, Heinrich, 1900- *Beitrage zur Kenntnis der pharmakologischen Wirkung des Oleanders. 20p. 8? Wiirzb., Gebr. Mem- minger, 1931. HARTWIG, Heinz [Hermann Karl] 1908- *Der Zellgehalt des Magensaftes als Ausdruck morphologischer Veranderungen der Magen- schleimhaut. 24p. 23cm. Greifsw., H. Adler, 1935. HARTWIG, Helmut, 1907- *Unter- suchungsergebnisse am Zahnsystem eines Fades von Chondrodystrophia hyperplastics. 14p. pl. 8? [Kiel] Kayser, 1935. HARTWIG, Hertha, 1911- *Ueber die Einwirkung einiger Salbengrundlagen auf die Wundheilung [Frankfurt] 12p. 21cm. Giiters- loh, Thiele, 1937. HARTWIG, Otto, 1905- *Ueber den Geburtsverlauf nach iiberstandenen Bauch- operationen. 16p. 8? Kiel, Flensburg. Nachr., 1931. HARTY, John Percy Ingham, 1881-1928. Obituary. Brit. M. J., 1928, 1: 576. HARTZ, Henry Jasper, 1861-1937. Obituary. Tr. Am. Lar. Rhin. Otol. Soc, 1939, 45: 477. HARTZ [Maximilian Wilhelm] Bruno, 1909- *Zur Frage der teratogenetischen Glied- massenverpflanzung. 20p. 8? Weende, A. F. Pieper, 1934. HARTZELL, Milton Bixler, 1854-1927. Dis- eases of the skin; their pathology and treatment. xiv, 753p. illust. 40 pl. 23^em. Phila., J. B. Lippincott Co., 1917. Also 2. ed. xi, 807p. illust. pl. 23^cm. 1919. For biography see Arch. Derm. Syph., Chic, 1927, 16: 56, portr. Also J. Am. M. Ass., 1927, 88: 1338. HARTZOG 95 HARVARD HARTZOG, Henry Simms, 1866- Tri- umphs of medicine, xv, 317p. 8? Garden City, N. Y., Doubleday, Page & Co., 1927. HARVARD alumni bulletin. Cambr., v.20, 1918- HARVARD alumni directory. 1940. xiii, 1695p. 24cm. Cambr., Harvard Univ., 1940. HARVARD College. Walter Bradford Can- non; exercises celebrating 25 years as George Higginson Professor of Physiology, Oct. 15, 1931. 94p. 8? Cambr., Harvard Univ. Press, 1932. HARVARD dental record. Bost., Mass., v.8, No. 4, 1934. HARVARD Laboratory of Physiology. The Harvard physiological apparatus; made under the direction of Prof. W. T. Porter. 51p. 12? Bost., Lord Electric Co. [190-] HARVARD Medical Alumni Association. The Quarterly. See Harvard University. HARVARD medical alumni bulletin. Bost., Mass., v.6-10, 1932-36. HARVARD Psychological Clinic. Explora- tions in personality; a clinical and experimental study of 50 men of college age, by the workers at the Harvard Psychological Clinic: Henry A. Murray [et al.] xiv, 761p. illust. diagrs. 24^cm. N. Y., Oxford Univ. Press, 1938. [HARVARD tercentenary conference of arts and sciences, Cambridge, Mass., 1936] Factors determining human behavior, vii, 168p. 8? Cambr., Harvard Univ. Press, 1937. Forms No. 1, Harvard Tercent. Conf. Pub. HARVARD University. Cambridge, Mass. Historical register of Harvard University, 1636- 1936. 484p. 8? Cambr., 1937. See also MacLeish, A. The next Harvard, p.582-93. 24J"3cm. Concord, 1941. (Clipping from: Atlantic Monthly, May 1941) Also Bauer, W. The tutorial system in Harvard Medical School. J. Am. M. Ass., 1941, 116: 792. Also J. Ass. Am. M. Coll., 1940, 15: 117-22.—Bowditch, H. P. Address. Q. Har- vard M. Alumni Ass., 1901-4, 605-9.—Cabot, A. T. Address. Ibid., 614-8.—Cooke, J. W. Into the bargain; comments relative to the Harvard School of Dental Medicine. Illinois Dent. J., 1941, 10: 61.—Coolidge. C. A. Address. Q. Harvard M. Alumni Ass., 1901-4, 618-21.—Folsom, C. F. Address. Ibid., 621-4.—Harvard (A) class after 20 years. J. Am. M. Ass., 1939, 112: 381.—Harvard in the Armv and Navy. Har- vard M. Alumni Bull., 1941, 43: 923-30.—Huber, E. G. The Alumni Association of the Harvard School of Public Health. Ibid., 1939-40, 14: 38-45.—Mallory, F. B. The Harvard Medical School exhibit at the St Louis Exposition. Q. Harvard M. Alumni Ass., 1901-4, 835-8.—Morison, S. E. Medicine at Harvard in the 17th century. Bull. Harvard M. Alumni, 1933, 8:1-4.—New school of dental medicine at Harvard. J. Am. M. Ass., 1940, 114: 2480.—Sesquicentennial of the Harvard Medical School. Bull. Harvard M. Alumni, 1933, 8: 21-30.— Shattuck, F. C. History of the Harvard Medical School. Med. J. & Rec, 1926, 124: 176-80.—Stone, A. K. A sketch of the Harvard Medical School, with special reference to the development of the Department of Theory and Practice. Q. Harvard M. Alumni Ass., 1901-4, 77-103, portr.—Viets, H. R. The founding of the Harvard Medical School. Bull. Harvard M. Alumni, 1933, 8: 4-8.—Warren, J. C. Address. Q. Har- vard M. Alumni Ass., 1901-4, 610-4. HARVARD University. Division of Anthro- pology. Statistical Laboratory. See Hooton, E. A. The American criminal. 309p. tab. 27cm. Cambr., Mass., 1939. HARVARD University. Institute for Tropical Biology and Medicine. Contributions. Cambr., Mass., v.l, No. 5, 1930; v.2, No. 5, 1930; No. 6, 1934. HARVARD University. Medical Alumni Asso- ciation. The Quarterly. Bost., Nos. 1-13, 1901-4. HARVARD University. Medical School. The- ory and practice. 1900-1. 22p. 8? Bost., T. Groom & Co., 1900. ---- The Aesculapiad, 1937. 120p. illust. portr. roy. 8? Bost., 1937. HARVARD University Medical School. De- partment of Diseases of the Nervous System. Collected papers. Bost., n. ser., v. 1-8, 1933-38. HARVARD University. Medical School. De- partment of Surgery. .~-See Homans, J., comp. A textbook of surgery. 5. ed. 1272p. 25cm. Springf., 111., 1940. HARVARD University. Medical School and Allied Hospitals. Proctor Fund. Studies on metabolism, [v. p.] 4? Bost. [n. pub.] 1922-25. HARVARD University. Museum of Compara- tive Zoology at Harvard College. Annual reports of the director. Cambr., Mass., 1880-81; 1883-84; 1885-88; 1890-91; 1892-1902; 1905-19; 1920- HARVARD University. School of Public Health. The environment and its effect upon man; symposium held at Harvard School of Public Health, August 24-August 29, 1936, as part of Harvard University tercentenary cele- bration, 1636-1936. 4, 297p. illust. tab. diagrs. roy. 8? Bost., 1937. ----Virus and rickettsial diseases, with especial consideration of their public health significance; a symposium held at the Harvard School of Public Health, June 12-17, 1939. xi, 907p. illust. pl. diagr. 24cm. Cambr., Mass., Harvard Univ. Press, 1940. HARVEST [and harvester] Farkas, G., Geldrich, J., & Szak&II, S. [On the energy used during harvest work] Magy. orv. arch., 1928, 29: 265-79.— Heller, A. A sommdsok 61elmez6se. Magy. statiszt. szemle, 1941, 19: 8-15.—Wolter, F. Die Entstehungsursache des Erntefiebers in ihrer Abhangigkeit von Boden und Klima. Hippokrates, Stuttg., 1937, 8: 612-7. HARVEST itch. See Trombidiidae. HARVET, I[srael] 16. cent. Discours par lequel est monstre contre le second paradoxe de la premiere decade de M. Laur. Ioubert, qu'il n'y a aucune raison que quelques uns puissent vivre sans manger, durant plusieurs jours & annees. 116p. 32? Niort, Thomas Portau, 1597 HARVEY, Basil Coleman Hyatt, 1875- Simple lessons in human anatomy. 434p. pl 8? Chic, Am. M. Ass. [1931] For biography see J. Am. M. Ass., 1940, 114: 2313. For portrait, photograph see collection in the library. HARVEY, C. O. The determination of iodine in biological substances. 43p. 8? Lond., H. M Stat. Off., 1935. Forms No. 201, Spec. Rep. Ser. Gr. Brit. M. Res. Counc. HARVEY, Dorothy. See Perry, Alan & Harvey, Dorothy. General nursing. 408p. 8? Lond., 1932. HARVEY, Edmund Newton, 1887- Living light, xv, 328p. 23K2cm. Princeton, Princeton Univ. Press, 1940. Also editor of Journal of cellular and comparative physiology. Phila., v.1-14, 1932-39. For portr., photograph see collection in library. HARVEY, Edwin Deeks, 1880- The mind of China, xi, 321p. 8? New Haven, Yale Univ. Press, 1933. ---- Social history of the yellow man. p.361- 414. 8? [Worcester, 1935] In Handb. social psychol. (Murchison, C.) Worcester, 1935. HARVEY, F. Health legislation (for students of the health services) x, 207p. 8? Lond., H. K. Lewis & Co., 1926. HARVEY, Nathan Albert, 1860- Ele- mentary psychology; a text-book for normal schools and for teachers' professional reading courses. 2 p. 1. 360p. 8? Chic, Row, Peterson & Co. [1914] HARVEY 96 HARVEY HARVEY. S. *Beitrage zur Rontgendiagno- stik des Kretinenschadels. 23p. 23cm. Bern, W. Fricdli-Kiing, 1939. HARVEY, Samuel Clark, lSS(i The history of hemostasis. xv, 128p. 8? N. Y., P. B. Hoeber, 1929. HARVEY, Verne K., 1X98- [Portrait] Proc. Conf. Health Author. N. America, 1940, 55. Meet., 1. HARVEY, William, 1578-1657. The works of William Harvey; trans, from the Latin, with a life of the author bv Robert Willis, xcvi, 024p. S? Lond., C. & J. Adlard, 1847. ----Exercitatio anatomica de motu cordis et sanguinis in animalibus; with an English transl. and annotations bv Chauncev D. Leake. 2 pts 6 p. 1. 72p. 2 1.;154p. 6 pl. "23cm. Springfield, 111., C. C Thomas, 1928. Also [2. ed.] xii, 2 1. 150p. 5 pl. 1931. Also 3. ed. xvii, 150p. pl. portr. facs. 1941. Reproduced from the 1928 tercentennial ed. For portrait, engraving, see collection in library. Also Surg. Gyn. Obst., 1939, 68: No. 2, front. For biography see Am. J. Surg.. 1928, 5: 302; 415 (A. Malloch) Also Ann. M. Hist,, 1923, 5: 26-33 (J. Donley) Also Bull. N. York Acad. M., 1941, 17: 161, portr. (L. F. Fris- soll) Also CLifton M. Bull.. 1925 26, 11: 143-53 (S. F. Service) Also Deut. med. Wschr., 1936, 62: 1974 (E. H. G. Atzrott) Also Edinburgh M. J., 1938, 45: 761 SI (H. Wade) Also Hvgeia, Chic, 1936, 14: 143 (A. Beilin) Also In Brit. Masters of Med. (Power, D'A.) Bait., 1936, 1-10 [portr.] (C. Briscoe) Also In Cardiac Classics (Willius, F. A.) S. Louis, 1941, 13-7, 2 portr. Also Lancet, Lond., 1927, 1: 623 (R. W. Lloyd) Also Lunds Ink. sail, forh., 1920-21, 95-126 (Ljungdahl) Also Marquette M. Rev., 1936-37, 1: 76 (J. A. Alston) Also Med. Press & Circ, Lond., 1934, 189: 4-7 (C. Briscoe) Also Miinch. nud. Wschr., 1928, 75: 658, portr. (K. Sudhoff) Also Ned. tschr. geneesk., 1928, 72: 2196-220 (F. M. G. de Feyfer) Also Newcastle M. J., 1928-29, 9: 164-8 (W. E. Hume) Also Rev. St. med., Bucur., 1928, 17: 525-63 (I). Ioncseu) Also Ugeskr. lteger, 1928, 90: 451-3 (J. Wiberg) Also Wien. med. Wschr., 1928, 78: 47-9 (L. Braun) See also DTrsay, S. A short list of works by and on Harvey; list II. 15p. fol. Florence [1928] Hutchison, R. Harvey; the man, his method, and his message for us today: being the Harveian oration delivered before the Royal College of Physicians of London on October 19th, 1931. 26p. 8? Oxf., 1931. Izqdierdo, J. J. Harvey; iniciador del metodo experimental; estudio critico de su obra De Motu Cordis y de los factores que la mantuvieron ignorada en los paises de habla espanola. 398p. 8? Mex., 1936. Malloch, A. E. William Harvey. 103p. 8? N. Y., 1929. Spencer, H. R. William Harvey, obstetric physician and gynaecologist; being the Harveian oration delivered at the Royal College of Phy- sicians, October 18th, 1921. 40p. 8? Lond., 1921. Also Alvarez-Sierra, J. Guillermo Harvev, en Lamberth. Med. ibera, 1934, 28: p. dxiii.— Bradford, J. R. The debt of medicine to the experimental method of Harvey. Brit. M. J. 1926,2:719-23.------The Harvey memorial tower. Ibid., 1933, 1: 28.—Casarotto, G. II terzo centenario della scoperta della circolazione del sangue: William Harvey ed il Rinasci- mento italiano. Cuore & circol., 1928, 12: 317-21.—Chauffard, A: L'ceuvre scientifique de W. Harvey. Presse med., 1928, 36: 657.—Descomps, P. Le troisidme centenaire du memoire de W. Harvey (1628-1928) Rev. med. fr., 1928, 9: 99-112.— Evans, G. H. A Harveian pilgrimage. California West. M., 1938, 48: 447-9.—Ferguson, J. H. Some medical heroes of the 17th, 18th, and 19th centuries. Edinburgh M. J., 1932, 39: 657-71, portr.—Fraser-Harris. D. F. William Harvey's knowledge of literature: classical, mediaeval, renaissance and contemporary. Med. Press & Circ, Dubl., 1934, 189: 164- 84.—George V, Bradford, J. R. [et al.] The Harvev celebra- tion; organised by the Royal College of Physicians of London. Lancet, Lond., 1928, 1: 1031-8.—Gley, E. L'Exercitatio ... de motu cordis et sanguinis de Harvey; sa signification; son developpement. Bull. Acad, med., Par., 1928, 3. ser 99: 551- 65.—Griffiths, G. William Harvey, M. D., F. It. C. P., some aspects of his genius. Med. J. Australia, 1928, 2: 396-8.— Guiart, J. Harvey et la circulation du sang. J. med. Lyon, 1928, 9: 365 71.- Harveian (The) celebrations; Lord Dawson on the Health services. Lmcet, bond., 1937, 2: 988- Harvey Memorial at Hempstead: the unfinished tower. Brit. M. J 1934, 2: 820, 4 pl- Hay. J. William Harvey, Ilia hist and greatest cardiologist. Liverpool Med. Chir. ,T., 1929, 37: 1 12 — Herringham, W. The life and times of Dr \\ illiam Harvev. Ann. M. Hist., 1932, I: 109; 219; 347; 419; 575. Hurrell, V. A medical pilgrimage. Newcastle M. J., 1928-29, 9: 169-76- ■ Hutchison, It. Harvev; The man, his method, and his message for us to-day. Lancet, Lond., 1931, 2: 887-93.- Keith. A. An appreciation of Harvey as anatomist. Ibid., 1928, 1: 999.— Krumbhaar, E. B. Bibliographical matters pertaining to the discovery of the cii dilation of the blood; based on the Ter- centenary exhibit of Hat veiana by the College of Physicians of Philadelphia. Ann Mil ist., 1929, n. ser., 1: 57-86. I.angdon. Brown, W. The buckgiound to Harvey. Lancet, Lond., 1936, 2- 961-7—Leake, ('. D. Harvey and cardiac output. Mod. Concepts Card. Dis., 1937, 6: No. 12, L—Ma.leod, J. J. K. Harvey's experiments on circulation. Ann. M. Hist., 1928, 10: 338-48.—Memorial (A) to William Harvey. Med. Press & Lire, Lond., 1934, 189: 383.—Memoirs of the celebrated Dr Harvey, from notes collected from the Bodleian Library and Ashmolean museum. Surg. Gyn. Obst., 1940, 70: 852-4.— Mosso, F. E. Biography: Andrea Cesalpino e Gughehno Harvey. Ann. med. nav., Roma, 1928, 34: 20-4.—Neuburyer, M. William Harvey; Gedenkworte anliisslich seines 350. Geburtstages. Wien. klin. Wschr., 1928, 41: 549-53.—New- man, G. The debt of preventive medicine to Harvey and the College of Physicians, delivered before the Royal College of Physicians of London on October 18th, 1932. Brit. M. J., 1932, 2: 739-44.—Packard, F. R. Harvey and the Tercente- nary celebration of his book De Motu Cordis et Sanguinis Hominis bv the Roval College of Physicians of London. Bull. M. Libr. Ass., 1929, n. ser., 18: 5-14.—Park, R. The story of the circulation. Uin. Key., Chic, 1905-6, 23: 860-86.— Philip, R. Relations of William Harvey to medicine in Edin- burgh. Brit. M.J., 1926, 2: 1029--33.—Pisek [Three hundredth anniversary of the discovery of blood circulation] Polska gaz. lek., 1928,~7: 877-80.—Power, D'A. Dr William Harvey and St Bartholomew's Hospital. S. Barth. Hosp. Rep., Lond., 1928, 61: 1-11.------A memorial group of the Harvey family [1549-1661] Ann. M. Hist., 1929, n. ser., 1: 241. ------ A purchase of land by the family of Dr William Harvey. Ibid., 1940, 3. ser., 2: 308-11.—Richet, C. Sur un manuscrit de William Haivev. Aesculape, Par., 1926, n. ser., 16: 118.— Robarts, H. II. If health be wanting. Edinburgh M. J., 1939, 46: 717-26.—Robinson, H. S. The first Harveian orator: Edward Emily (1617-57) Med. Life, 1927, 34: 30-6.----- The Harveian orators: from Edmund Wilson to the orator of the plague year. Ibid., 337-54, 4 portr.—Rodin, F. H. The lure of medical history, William Harvey; de Motu Cordis. California West. M., 1928, 29: 406; 1929, 30: 46.—Holies ton, H. Harvev's predecessors and contemporaries. Ann. M. Hist., 1928, 10: 323-37.—Stuart, W. J. Harvey and integration. Edinburgh M. J., 1936, 43: 438-51.—Sutton, H. William Harvey; the man and his times. Med. J. Australia, 1928, 2: 392-6.—Tercentenary celebration of William Harvey's De Motu Cordis. Med. J. & Rec, N. Y., 1928, 128: 45.—William Harvey's church. Lancet, Lond., 1934, 2: 1011.—Williams, D. The Harvey Chapel at Hempstead. Brit. M. J., 1928, 1: 816-8.—Willius, F. A., & Keys, T. E. William Harvey's epoch-making contribution on the heart and circulation and its effect on modern medicine. Proc. Mayo Clin., 1940, 15: 333- 5.—Zum Busch, J. P. Die Harveian Oration des Royal College of Physicians in London. Schweiz. med. Wschr., 1938, 68: 1041. See also Blood circulation, History. HARVEY, William, 1807-76. On corpulence in relation to disease: with some remarks on diet. xi, 148p. illust. 8? Lond., H. Renshaw, 1872. HARVEY, William Clunie, 1900- , & HILL, Harry. Insect pests, ix, 292p. illust. 19cm. Lond., H. K. Lewis & Co., 1940. HARVEY Cushing Society. A bibliography of the writings of Harvey Cushing; prepared on the occasion of his 70th birthday, April 8, 1939. 4 p. 1. [xiii]-xv, 108p. portr. 23>km. [Springf., 111.] C. C. Thomas, 1939. ----Harvey Cushing's 70th birthday party, April 8, 1939; speeches, letters, and tributes; published for the Harvey Cushing Society, vii p. 31. 146p. illust. facs. portr. 23cm. [Springf., 111.] C. C. Thomas, 1939. HARVEY K. Cushing Laboratory of Experi- mental Medicine. Cleveland, Ohio. See Western Reserve University. HARVEY Society [U. S. A.] Harvey lectures, delivered under the auspices of ... of New York. Ser. 1-35, 1905-40. 35 v. 8? Bait., Williams & Wilkins, 1906-38. HARVEY 97 HASCOET For the British Harvey Society see under London. See also Harvey (The) Society, a society for the diffusion of knowledge of the medical sciences, constitution. In Harvey Lect. (Harvey Soc.) N. Y., 1912-13, ser. 8, 3.—Harvey (The) Society; constitution, members, etc. Ibid., 1939-40, ser. 35, 5-34.—Lusk, G. The Harvey Society. Ibid., 1931, ser. 25, 205-9.—Officers and members of the Harvey Society; 1939-40. Ibid., 1938-39, ser. 34, 7-33. HARVIER, Paul. Pathologie digestive. 162p. illust. 8? Par., Masson & cie, 1935. HARWELL, R. R. *The principal versions of Baruch. 66p. 8? [n. p., n. pub., 1915] HARWOOD, Dix, 1893- *Love for animals, and how it developed in Great Britain [Columbia Univ.] 381p. 8? N. Y. [n. pub.] 1928. HARWOOD, Eliza Josephine. How we train the body; the mechanics of pantomimic technique 3 p. 1. vii, 142p. illust. diagrs. 8? Bost., W. H. Baker Co. [1933] HARWOOD, Henry Hamilton. What causes cancer? are the views, the theories, of Hutchin- son, Baronaki, Cresswell, Crow, Robinson, Ross, Drew, Lane, correct and of value for the preven- tion, and the treatment of cancer? a study. 76p. 8? Richmond, H. H. Harwood [1926] HARWOOD, Louis de Lotbiniere, 1866-1934. Ddces du professeur de Lotbiniere Harwood, membre associ6 stranger. Bull. Soc. nat. chir., Par., 1934, 60: 790.— Nicholls, A. G. [Obituary] Canad. M. Ass. J., 1934, 31: 539- 41.—Roussy, G. Necrologie. Presse med. 1934, 42: 949. HARZ, Johanna, 1901- *Ueber euro- paische Chylurie (Auszug) 16p. 8? Lpz., E. Lehmann, 1925. HARZ [Germ.] Schroder, K. Der Harz als Kurgebiet. 120p. 8? Braunschweig, 1936. HARZER, Paul. Theoretische und praktische Untersuchungen iiber die Bestimmung der Randverdunkelung der Sonne aus aktinischen Energiemessungen wahrend einer Sonnenfinster- nis. 60p. 4? Munch., R. Oldenbourg, 1931. Forms n. F., Heft. 8, Abh. Bayer. Akad. Wiss. ---- Tabellen fiir alle statistischen Zwecke in Wissenschaft und Praxis, insbesondere zur Ablei- tung des Korrelations-Koeffizienten und seines mittleren Fehlers. 91p. 4? Miinch. [n. pub.] 1933. Forms n. F., Heft 21, Abh. Bayer. Akad. Wiss. HARZHEIM, Christian [Josef] 1904- *Ueber nachtragliche Feststellung der Geschafts- unfahigkeit bei progressiver Paralyse. 47p. 8? [Bonn, n. pub.] 1935. HARZIELLA. See Fungi imperfecti. HASAMIYAMI. See Leptospirosis. HASBROUCK, Cornelius Van Dyke, 1855- 1924. Obituary. J. Am. M. Ass., 1924, 82: 1137. HASCAL, Aizic, 1905- *Etude sur les facteurs de 1'evolution de la nosologie (maladies 6teintes et maladies nouvelles) 56p. 8? Par., L. Rodstein, 1933. HASCHEM, Abdel Latif, 1898- *Die Ursache der Sterilitat der Frau. 43p. 8? Munch, [n. pub.] 1927. HASCHENZ, Walter, 1910- *Variations- statistische Untersuchungen iiber das Gewicht der reifen Frucht und der Placenta. 23p. 8? Gott. [n. pub.] 1934. HASCOET, Hilda Camille, 1907- Con- tribution a l'etude du pronostic des pleurisies sero-fibrineuses tuberculeuses. 63p. 8? Par., Le Francois, 1932. HASELAU, Hans [Otto Andreas] 1914- *Zum Vorkommen und zur Pathogenese der Kehlkopftuberkulose beim Rind (nach Unter- suchungen am Schlachthof in Weissenfels) 39p. 8? Lpz., A. Edelmann, 1937. HASELBECK, Friedrich, 1908- *Seltene Verlaufsarten der Polyarthritis rheumatica. 32p. 8? Erlangen, K. Dores, 1936. HASELHOFF, Hans. *Die sarkomatbse De- generation von Myomen und das Nebeneinander- vorkommen von Myom und Karzinom. 50p. 8? [Gott., K. H. Scheithauer, 1926] HASELHORST, Charlotte, 1914- *Ueber die Kiefertumoren. 29p. 23%cm. Halle, E. Klinz, 1938. HASELMANN, Gerhard, 1907- *Der Wert der Rontgendiagnose bei Dickdarm-Er- krankungen unter besonderer Berucksichtigung des Umbrathorverfahrens [Greifswald] 28p. 8? Grossenhain, H. Plasnick, 1933. HASELMANN, Ruth, 1910- *Ueber die verschiedenen Formen der progressiven Paralyse und ihre Beziehung zum Behandlungserfolge [Halle] 15p. 22>/2cm. Wurzb., R. Mayr, 1937. HASELMAYR, Irmingard, 1913- *Die geringere Sterblichkeit gestillter Sauglinge im Spiegel einer Untersuchung von 450 Siiuglings- todesfallen. 22p. 23cm. Munch., L. Mosel, 1937. HASELTINE, Burton, 1874-1934. [Obituary] Med. Rec, N. Y., 1934, 139: 505. HASEMANN, Philipp, 1909- *Ueber die Bedeutung und Anwendbarkeit des Immediat- Zahnersatzes. 20p. 8? Bonn, P. Kubens, 1934. HASENBACH, Josef, 1906- *Ueber das Os acetabuli unter besonderer Berucksichtigung der Unfallchirurgie. p.81-96. 8? Bonn, P. Kubens, 1932. Also Arch, orthop. UnfaUchir., 1932, 31: HASENBEIN, Karl Heinz, 1910- *Ueber Vorkommen und Wesen der Hirn- und Hirnhaut- geschwiilste im Gottinger Leichengut 1900-35. 19p. 21cm. Weende, F. Pieper, 1937. HASENEST, Christoph Balthasar. *De affecti- bus rheumatico-arthriticis cito tutoque curandis. 36p. 19cm. Altdorf, J. A. Hessel [1743] In P. v. Altdorf theses pt 1, No. 5. HASENFELD, Arthur, 1870-1940. Torday, A. [Obituary] Budapesti orv. ujs., 1941, 39: No. 3, p. iii. Also Orv. hetil., 1941, 85: 38. HASENFUSS, Werner, 1910- Unter- suchungen iiber den geistigen Zustand von Kin- dern der wegen angeborenen Schwachsinns sterilisierten Frauen, nebst Aufnahmen fiber den Gesundheitszustand der Operierten und ihrer sozialen Verhaltnisse [Heidelberg] 31p. 22cm. Speyer, H. Gilardone, 1937. HASENJAEGER, Ella. Asepsis in communi- cable-disease nursing; principles and practice as applied in a communicable-disease hospital with practical teaching suggestions. 8 p. 1. 151p. illust. form. 17}£cm. Phila., J. B. Lippincott Co. [1940] HASENJAEGER, Fritz, 1911- *Karies- Immunitat und -Resistenz der Zahne [Munchen] 40p. 8? Speyer, Pilger, 1937. HASHI, K. 'See Psychiatria et neurologia japonica. Tokio, v.39-43, 1935-39. HASHIDA, Kunikiko, 1882- Editor of The Journal of biophysics. Tokyo, v.1-2,1923-27. Also Japanese journal of medical science, pt. 3: Biophysics. Tokyo, v.1-5, 1928-38. 227475—VOL. 7, 4th series- HASHIMOTO'S DISEASE 98 HASMER HASHIMOTO'S disease. Sec Thvroid, Inflammation. HASHING KR, Edward Hagerman, 1892- Soc Clendening, L., Hashinger, E. H. [et al.] Methods of treatment. 7. ed. 997p. 25cm. S. Louis, 1941. HASHISH. See Cannabis. HASKELES, Maurice, 1911- *Le reflexe oculo-cardiaque dans l'hvpertension arterielle 35p. 8? Par., L. Arnette, 1937. HASKELL, Charles ( . See Christian, William Gay, & Haskell, Charles C. A text- bock of physiology for nurses. 2. ed. 153p. 8? S. Louis, 1929. HASKELL, Joseph Noyes, 1876- See Froschels, Emil. Speech therapy. 252p. 8? Bost. [1933] HASKELL, Loomis P. Student's manual and hand-book for the dental laboratory; iv, 97p. 8? Phila., Wilmington Dent. Mig Co., 1890. ---- Haskell's manual of plate work; or, Handbook for the dental laboratory. 2. ed. 63p. portr. 8? Chic, L. P. Haskell, 1910. HASKINS, Caryl Parker, 1908- Of ants and men. ix, 244p. pl. 23)-cm. N. Y., Prentice Hall, 1939. HASKINS, Charles Homer, 1870-1937. Birkenmajer, A. Necrologie. Archeion, Roma, 1937, 19: 3G6. HASKINS, Howard Davis, 1871- See Osgood. Edwin Eugene, & Haskins, Howard D. A textbook of l:ib(.ni.tory diagnosis [&c] 475p. 8! Phila., 1931. HASKINS, R. W. History and progress of phrenology (read before the Western Phrenologi- cal Society, at Buffalo) iv, 217p. 8? Buffalo, Steele & Peck, 1839. HASKOVEC, Ladislav, 1866- Editor of Revue v neurologii a psychiatrii. Praha. v.24. 1927- [Portrait] Ment. Hyg., Alb., 1930, 14: No. 2.—Sebek, J. [Seventieth anniversary] Cas. lek. desk., 1936, 75: G2C-30. HASLA.M, J[ohn] Ffearby] ( [ampbell] Recent advances in preventive medicine; with a chapter on the vitamins by S. J. Cowed, viii, 328p. 5 pl. 8? Lond., J. & A. Churchill, 1930. HASLAM, William Frederick, 1858-1932. G, L. [Obituary] Brit. M. J., 1932, 1: 453- HASLBECK, Matthias, 1909- *Ueber familiaren Situs inversus totalis (eine Beobach- tung bei drei Briidern) 23p. 4 pl. 8? Erlangen- Bruck, M. Krahl, 1937. HASLER, Jiirg, 1909- *Erfahrungen an weiteren Bronchiektasie-Patienten [Zurich] p.630-52. 25cm. Lpz., Spamer, 1939. Also Beitr. Klin. Tuberk., 1939, 93: HASLHOFER, L. Die Engel-Recklinghau- sensche Knochenkrankheit (Ostitis bzw. Osteo- dystrophia fibrosa generalisata v. Reckling- hausen) p.342-476. 8? Berl., 1937. In Handb. spez. path. Anat. ^cm. Lond., Brit. Mus., 1937. HASTINGS, George A. Registration of the feebleminded. 15p. 8? N. Y., Comm. Ment. Hyg. [1918] HASTINGS, Charles, 1794-1866. [Biography] Brit. M. J., 1932, 2: 161. HASTINGS, Charles John Colwell Oliver, 1858-1931. Fleming, G. [Obituary] Canad. M. Ass. J., 1931, 24: 473. HASTINGS, H. J. The history and develop- ment of personal accident and sickness insurance. 47p. 12? Lond., Post Magazine, 1922. HASTINGS, Milo M[ilton] 1884- The egg trade of the United States. 34p. 8? Wash., Gov. Print. Off., 1909. Forms Circ. No. 140 U. S. Bur. Anim. Indust. HASTINGS, Samuel D. On hospitals for the insane; with particular reference to separate establishments for the chronic insane poor. 98p. 8? [n. p., n. pub., 1866] HASTINGS, William W. Manual for physical measurements for use in normal schools, boys' clubs, girls' clubs', and Young Men's Christian Associations with anthropometric tables for each height of each age and sex from 5 to 20 years, and vitality coefficients, xviii, 112p. fol. Springf., Mass., 1902. HASTINGS, Eng. East Sussex, Hastings, and St Leonard's Infirmary. Annual report. Hastings, 32., 1871-72. HASTINGS, Eng. Hastings Dispensary. An- nual report. Hastings, 55.-71., 1884-1900. HASTINGS, Eng. Hastings and St Leonard's- on-Sea Home for Invalid Gentlewomen. Annual report. Hastings, 28. (1883) 1884. HASTINGS, Nebr. Asylum for the Chronic Insane (formerly Asylum for the Incurably In- sane) Biennial report. Hastings, 2.-5., 1890-98. HASTREITER, Hans, 1907- *Ein Fall von Epipharynx-Carcinom [Munchen] 23p. 8? Wurzb., K. Triltsch, 1935. HASTREITER, Ludwig, 1908- *Die Schwangerschaftsunterbrechung durch Aerzte de lege lata et de lege ferenda [Wurzburg] 44p. 8? Kallmiinz, M. Lassleben, 1935. HASTREITER, Rolland Frederick, 1875-1941. J., R. H. Obituary. California West. M., 1941, 54: 288. HASWELL, William Aitcheson, 1854-1925. See Parker, T. J., & Haswell, W. A. A text-book of zoology. 6. ed. 2v. 25Hcm. Lond., 1940. HAT. See also Eczema, Causes. Clerici, A. Eczemi da cappelli per donne. Gazz. osp., 1931, 52- 257-9.—Frei, W. Kopfekzeme durch Frauenhiite. Deut. med Wschr., 1931, 57: 55-7.—Genner, V. [Hat strap eczema] Hospitalstidende, 1936, 79: [Dansk derm, selsk. forh.] 17. HATA 100 HAT INDUSTRY HATA. Sahachiro, 1S73-1938 Kitashima. T. Obituary. Kitasato Arch., 1939, 16: p. i-iv, portr.—Nekrolog. Derm. Zschr., 1938, 78: 456.— Schlossberger, IL Nekrolog. Deut. med. Wschr., 1939, 65: 32, portr. For portrait see collection in library. HA-TA-NGOC, 1908- *Contribution a l'etude de l'amygdalectomie totale a chaud. 38p. 24cm. Par., Jouve & cie, 1939. HATCH, J. Lemngwell. Protonuclein in cer- tain diseases of the throat and ear. 4p. 8? [N. Y., n. pub., n. d.] HATCH, L. M., -1894. To the coast rangers on cleanliness. 12p. 8? [Charleston, n. pub., 186-?] HATCH, Theodore Frederick, 1901- See Drinker. Philip, & Hatch, T. F. Industrial dust. 316p. 8! N. Y., 193(1. HATCHER, Robert A[nthony] 1868- The duty of the medical profession toward the council on pharmacy and chemistry. 10p. 8? [n. p., n. pub.] 1916. See also American Medical Association. Council on Phar- macy and Chemistry. Useful ilruns. 8.-12. ed. 12? Chic, 1930-40. ----IRONS, Ernest E. [et al.] Epitome of the Pharmacopeia of the United States and the National Formulary,with comments. 238p. 16? Chic, Am. M. Ass. [1931] Also [5. ed.] 240p. [1936] Also 6. ed. 246p. 1940. HATCHET (The) of the United States Ship George Washington. Iv. N. Y., v.1-8, 1918. HATCHING. See Egg. HATEM, Shafick. *Le Wassermann irr6- ductible [Geneve] 18p. 8? Annemasse, J. Rosnoblet, 1933. HATFIELD, H. D. Sec Ransdell, J. E., Copeland, R. S., & Hatfield, H. D. How to conserve public health [etc.] 51p. 8! Wash., 1931. HATFIELD, Malcolm. Children in court; a study of juvenile delinquency, ix, 184p. 8? N. Y., Paebar Co., 1938. HATFIELD, Marcus Patten, 1849-1909. Com- pend of diseases of children; especially adapted for the use of medical students. 3. ed. viii, 241p. 12? Phila., P. Blakiston's son & co., 1903. HATHAWAY, Benjamin Adams, 1852- One thousand and one questions and answers on physiology and hygiene. 99p. 16? Lebanon, O., 1887. HATHAWAY, Esse Virginia, 1871- See Meanes, Lenna Leota, & Hathaway, Esse V. Exercises for health. 71p. 16? N. Y., 1924. HATHAWAY, H. G. The disposal of the wounded of cavalry. 8p. 4 pl. 8? Simla, Gov. Centr. Print. Off., 1900. HATHAWAY, William R. L., 1877-1940. Obituary. J. Maine M. Ass., 1940, 31: 208. HATHWAY, Marion. The young cripple and his job. 130p. 8? Chic, Univ. Chicago, 192S. HATIEGANU, Vlad, 1906- *Contribution a I'e'tude physio-pathologique des grandes hemor- ragies. 52p. 8? Par., M. Vigne, 1932. HAT industry. Neal, P. A., Flinn, R. H. [et al.] Mercu- rialism and its control in the felt-hat industry. 15 fig. 23cm. Wash., 1941. Neal, P. A., Jones, R. R. [et al.] A study of chronic mercurialism in the hatters' fur-cutting industry. 70p. a? Wash., D. C, 1937. Allemagne. Ordonnance du 26 mars 1938, travail, concer- nant les fabriques de chapeaux de feutre. Bull. Off. internat. hyg. pub., Par., 1939, 31: 570-3—Elod, E. Ueber das Beizen von Huthaaren. Arbeitsschutz, 1937, 16.—Farnham, R. What ails the millinery industry. Labor Inform. Bull., Wash., 1939 6- No 8 8-11. Fraschctti. V. Inchiesta sulle condition! delle modisicric?, -1,11, modiste i».Rrn\Jd VIteiruSdu„Jj 321-35.--Haarhu,fabrik,,, P>™*»™w^J£TSn Reichsgesundhbl., I'.'.iS, id. •>-" "• ,,«,oitl, nPn Wash rontrol in the felt-hat industry. Pub. Health Kep., wasn. 941 56: 663._Problem of control of mercurialism in the manufacture of fur felt hats. Connecticut Health Bull.. 1941, 55: 155-7. HATRED. See also Anger; Fear. Claude. H.. & Robin, G. Les haines famihales rnorbides. Pre-s,. n.,.,1., 1926, 34: 609—Robin, G. Les haines famihales en pathologie mental.-. Ann. med. psychol., Par., 1926, 84: 309-79__— Ilaincs famihales et psychanalyse. Kev. gen. clin "ther 1926, 40: 325-8.—Ruiz-Maya. Odu famdian paranoidi. ' Arch, antrop. crim., Tor., 1930, 50: 560-9. HATSCHEK, Emil, 1868- An introduc- tion to the physics and chemistry of colloids. 5. ed. xiii, 183p. 12? Lond., J. & A. Churchill, 1925. ---- Laboratory manual of elementary colloid chemistry. 2. ed. ix, 153p. 12? Lond., J. & A. Churchill, 1925. HATSCHEK, Gustav, 1909- *Peritonitis- Todesfalle nach primar nicht eitrigen Bauch- operationen der Jahre 1920-30. 60p. 21cm. Weende, F. Pieper, 1935. HATSCHEK, Paul. Optik des Unsichtbaren; eine Einfiihrung in die Welt der Elektronen- Optik. 149p. illust. 8? Stuttg., Franck [1937] HATTE, Jean Baptiste, 1727-62. Eloge de M. le Docteur Hatt6. p.409-16. 16? [n. p.] 1762. HATTEMER, Adam Josef, 1907- *Die Bedeutung von Zahnreihen-Anomalien fiir die Atmungsverhaltnisse bei den Kindern der Wiirz- burger Volksschulen im Alter von 7 und 13 Jahren. 16p. 8? Wurzb., R. Mayr, 1933. HATTENBACH, Otto Christian, 1735-1808. See Klemm, H. *Otto Christian Hattenbach; Amtmann in Sontra (1735-1808) und seine Nachkommen [Wurzburg] 159p. 26cm. Heilbronn, 1938. HATTENKERL, Gerda, 1908- *Die Dauerresultate der Collum-Carcinom-Behand- lung in der Greifswalder Universitats-Frauen- klinik 1922-27. 16p. 8? Greifsw., H. Adler, 1935. HATTERY, Seth, 1849? McMillan, T. A. [Biography] Ohio M. J., 1940, 36: 1203-5, portr. HATTI, Joseph. *L'endocardite ulcereuse lente. 27p. 8? Geneve, J. Privat, 1925. HATTINGBERG, Christa von, 1911- *Zur Frage der Encephalomyelitis postvaccinalis [Heidelberg] 21p. 8? Wiirzb., K. Triltsch, 1937. HATTINGBERG, Hans von, 1879- Psy- cho-analysis and neuroses; translated by Arnold Eiloart. 192p. 8? Lond., C. W. Daniel Co. [1931] ---- The technique of psycho-analysis; transl. by Arnold Eiloart. 136p. 12? Lond., C. W. Daniel Co. [1932] Also editor of Zeitschrift fiir Menschenkunde. Celle, v.1-11, 1925/26-35/36. See also Dieterle, R. R. The relation of Hans von Hatting- berg to psycho-analysis; an appreciation. Psychoanal. Rev., Wash., 1930, 17: 268-73. HATTON, England. County of Warwick Pauper Lunatic Asylum. Annual reports of the committee of visitors. Warwick, 2.-[5.] 1857-61; 1882-93;1898/9918-99/1900. ---- General report. Warwick (1852-55) 1856. ---- General rules, regulations and orders. Warwick, 1853. HATZIOLOS, Basile Sauveur Constantin, 1902- *L'ecthyma contagieux du mouton (a propos d'une 6pizootie observee en Grece) [Alfort] 72p. 8? Par., Jouve & cie, 1929 HATZMANN 101 HAUCH HATZMANN, Erich, 1910- *Versuche zur Ermittlung der fiir die respiratorische Funk- tion der menschlichen Nase bestimmenden Gros- sen [Munster] 28p. 21cm. Bottrop, W. Post- berg, 1936. HATZOLD, Karl, 1913- *Die Zusam- menhange zwischen Formanohialien der Zahne und erblichen Geistesstorungen. 46p. 8? Er- langen, K. Dores, 1937. HAU, Andre Jacques Emile, 1909- ♦.Con- tribution a l'etude de la primo-infection tubercu- Ieuse benigne chez l'adulte avec l'6rytheme noueux. 104p. 3 pl. 8? Par., Jouve & cie, 1935. HAUB, Kornel, 1909- *Ueber das Zu- riicklassen von Fremdkorpern bei Laparotomien. 28p. 8? Wiirzb., K. Roll, 1935. HAUB, Paul Ferdinand, 1908- *Schar- lachendemie in einem Kinderheime. lOp. 8? Wurzb., K. Roll, 1935. HAUBENREISER, Emil, 1910- *Die neueren Narkoseverfahren mit besonderer Be- riicksichtigung ihrer Verwendbarkeit in der Zahnheilkunde. 24p. 8? Miinch., Bayer. Dr., 1934. HAUBENREISER, Paul Werner, 1907- *Der tuberkulose primare Herd beim Rinde nach Untersuchungen am Material des Schlachthofes in Gera-Thuringen. 31p. 8? Eythra-Lpz., P. Kohler, 1934. HAUBENREISSER, Gerhard, 1912- *Der Einfluss des Palladiumgehaltes in Legie- rungen auf Tiefung und auf Aufhebung der Verfarbungsmoglichkeiten durch Schwefelwas- serstoff. 24p. 21cm. Berl., Silesia, 1937. HAUBENSAK, Willy. *Zur Lehre von den Degenerationszeichen. 51p. 8? Ziir., H. A. Gutzwiller, 1926. Also Schweiz. Zschr. Gesundhpfl., 1926. HAUBER, Erich, 1901- *Magenkrebs und Kriegsdienstbeschadigung. 20p. 8? Munch., C. Wolf & Sohn, 1934. HAUBER, Ulrich Albert, 1885- , & O'HAN- LON, Ellen. Biology; a study of the principles of life for the college student, xii, 559p. illust. 8? N. Y., F. S. Crofts, 1937. HAUBERG, Poul. Christiern Pedersens laege- bog, Malm0 1533. 32 [v. p.] 8? Kbh., Levin & Munksgaard, 1933. Facsimile ed. HAUBNER, Anton, 1901- *Ueber einen weiteren Fall von Blasenverletzung bei kriminel- lem Abort [Munchen] 15p. 8? Neuhaldens- leben, W. Schwirkus [1924] HAUBOLD, Hellmut [Gottfried] 1905- *Ueber den Einfluss von bestrahltem Ergosterin auf Struktur und Verkalkung des Tuberkels bei der experimentellen Meerschweinchentuberku- lose. p.633-43. 8? Freib. i. B., Fischer, 1932. Also Beitr. path. Anat., 1932, 89: ---- Krebs und Krebsbekampfung in Frank- reich. ix, 273p. tab. ch. 8? Lpz., J. A. Barth, 1936. HAUBOLD, Werner, 1910- *DurchZahn- retention hervorgerufene klinische Erscheinungen [Leipzig] 35p. 2 pl. 8? Zeulenroda, A. Ober- reuter, 1933. _ ,., „ , HAUBRICH, Karl, 1907- *Die Erfah- rungen der Marburger Universitats-Ohrenklinik fiber die vollstandige Aufmeisselung der Mittel- ohrraume bei Kindern. 43p. 8? Marb., J. Hamel, 1932. HAUCH, Erik Sophus Adam, 1871- Haandbog for jordemodre. 2 p. 1. 417p. roy. 8. Kbh., Gyldendal Nord. Fori., 1919. HAUCH, Francis Mathias. *The treatment of pre-eclampsia and eclampsia [St Elizabeth Hosp.] 23 1. 28cm. Appleton, Wis., 1941. Typewritten. HAUCH, Fritz, 1900- *Beitrag zur Kenntnis der diatetischen Behandlung von Infek- tionskrankheiten und anderes im 17. und 18. Jahrhundert. 33p. 8? Erlangen, K. Dores, 1930. HAUCK, Edmund, 1908- *Zur Fest- stellung der Ueberfiitterung bei Schlachttieren. 35p. 23#cm. Giessen, W. Herr, 1938. HAUCK, Friedrich, 1909- ♦Trauma- tische und spontane Ruptur von Hydronephrose [Heidelberg] 27p. 8? Landau, Pfalz, Sudpfalz. Verlag, 1938. HAUCK, Fritz, 1908- *Ueber einen Fall von blasiger Erweiterung des vesicalen Ureter- endes bei Fehlen der Niere. 23p. 8? Miinch., O Boeck 1935 HAUCK, Gertrud, 1910- *Diffuse Horn- hauttriibung nach Art einer Keratitis parenchy- matosa nach Conjunctivitis diphterica [Wurz- burg] 15p. 8? Erlangen, K. Dores, 1935. HAUCK, Hazel M. How to control your weight. 18p. illust. 8? Ithaca, N. Y., 1935. Forms No. 329 Cornell Bull. Homemakers. HAUCK, Leo, 1874- Die Behandlung der Geschlechtskrankheiten; Leitfaden fiir den prak- tischen Arzt. 2. Aufl. vii, 218p. 8? Lpz., F. C. W. Vogel, 1928. ---- Tripper der Mundschleimhaut, der Nase, der Ohren, des Mastdarms, des Auges; Allgemeinkrankheiten bei Tripper, p.347-422. 8? Berl., 1934. In Haut- u. Geschlechtskr. (Arzt & Zieler) Berl., 1934, 5: HAUCK, Louis, 1859-1940. Grindon, J., sr. [Obituary] Week. Bull. S. Louis M. Soc, 1940-41, 35: 422. HAUDEK, Martin, 1880-1931. Fleischner. Nekrolog. Fortsch. Rontgenstrahl., 1931, 43: 77.—Holzfcnecht. [Biography] Miinch. med. Wschr., 1931,, 78: 593, portr.—Schwarz, G. Nekrolog. Strahlentherapie 1931,41:201-4. For portrait, photograph see collection in library. HAUDRERE, Jean, 1911- *Contribution a l'etude du cancer du corps de l'uterus [Paris] 71p. 24cm. Alencon, Alengonnaise, 1939. HAUDUROY, Paul, 1897- Les ultra- virus et les formes filtrantes des microbes; les maladies a ultravirus, leurs caracteres cliniques, anatomopathologiques, 6pid6miologiques, 1 im- munite, techniques, d'6tude des ultravirus, les formes filtrantes des bacteries. 2 p. 1. 392p. 8? Par., Masson & cie, 1929. ---- Les ultravirus pathogenes et saprophytes; techniques d'etude, caracteres physiques et biologiques, maladies a ultravirus, clinique; anatomo-pathologie, epidemiologic. 462p. illust. 8? Par., Masson & cie, 1934. ----EHRINGER, G. [et al.] Dictionnaire des bacteries pathogenes; pour I'homme, les animaux et les plantes. 597p. 8? Par., Masson & cie, 1937. HAUEISEN, Hilde, 1910- *Zur thera- peutischen Verwendung einheimischer Saponin- drogen. 19p. 8? Tub., Bolzle, 1937. HAUEISEN, Hugo, 1903- *Blutverluste nach zahnarztlichen Operationen. 22p. 8? Rostock, C. Hinstorff, 1928. HAUER, August, 1886- Der Triumph der deutschen Tropenmedizin; arztliche Be- trachtungen uber das Drama in Ostafrika. 24p. 8? Charlottenb., P. Raabe, 1922. HAUER 102 HAUG ---- Aerztlicher Berater fiir Uebersee und Tropen. 2. Aufl. xii, 327p. illust. diagrs. 8? Berl., G. Stilke, 1936. ---- Die Wcltgeltung der deutschen Tropen- medizin. 31p;lp. illust. 8? Berl., J.Schneider [1936] HAUER, Josef, 1909- , & PREIS, Herbert. *Das rote Blutbild wahrend der Schwangerschaft und im Wochenbett mit besonderer Beriicksich- tigung des Aderlasses und der Blutregeneration [Heidelberg] 22p. 21cm. Wurzb., K. Triltsch, 1937. HAUER, Katarina, 1899- *Ueber einen Fall von oral entstandener eitriger Meningitis (Gefahren der Leitungsinjektion bei der Zahn- behandlung) 20p. 8? Munch., F. X. Seitz, 1933 HAUER, Lothar, 1910- *Die Ausnutzung ungekochter Starke. 23p. 21cm. Frankf., F. Darmstadter, 1938. HAUER, Peter, 1898- *Die Kaltempfind- Iichkeit der Genitalien [Wurzburg] p.265-74. 8? Miinch., J. F. Lehmann, 1926. Also Zschr. Biol., 1926, 85: HAUER-MERRES, Gerda, 1911- *Die Grenzen der Leistungsfahigkeit bei Abscess- tonsillektomie. 20p. 23cm. Greifsw., H. Adler, 1936. HAUERT, Andre, 1907- *De la resection duganglion 6toil6 danslestroubles circulatoires du membre supe>ieur. 64p. 8? Par., L'Entente Lino, 1935. HAUF, Maria, 1902- *Zur Kenntnis der atonisch-astatischeh Diplegie der zerebralen Kinderliihmung [Wurzburg] 15p. 2 1. 8? Karlsruhe, Engelhardt & Bauer, 1927. HAUF, Maurice J. *Contribution a l'etude de la structure de l'uterus chez le foetus humain. 44p. 8? Lausanne [n. pub.] 1929. HAUFE, Manfred, 1902- *Ueber das Verhalten des Alkohols im Harn. 40p. 8? Jena, G. Fischer, 1928. HAUFF, Hans. Hoe Klare. Knit, & Hauff, Hans. Die chirurgische Tuber- kulose des Kindesalters in typischen Rontgenbildern. [p.219- 26] 8°. Lpz., 1929. HAITI E, Georg, 1872-1936. Herz, Pulsation und Blutbewegung; die Pulsation am Herzen und am Gefiissgebiete als zwangslaufig mechanischer Vorgang und das Herz als einziger Motor zur Erhaltung des Blutkreislaufes. 246p. 8? Munch., J. F. Lehmanns Verlag, 1930. Fcr biography see Hippokrates, Stuttg., 1936, 7: 597 (Feld- mann) Also Munch, med. Wschr., 1936, 83: 1508, portr. (W. Anton) Also Naturarztl. Rdsch., 1936, 8: 265-7 (M. Fass- bender) HAUFNIENSIS, Virgilius, pseud. See Kierkegaard. Soren. HAUG, Adolf, 1912- *Die Steuerung des Leberglykogengehaltes bei eiweissfreier Ernah- rung durch Tyrosin. 20p. 23cm. Berl.-Charlot- tenb., K. & R. Hoffmann, 1938. HAUG, Hermann, 1892-1936. Vogt. H. Nekrolog. Balneologe, 1936, 3: 401. HAUG, Joseph, 1908- *Ueber angeborene Diinndarm- beziehungsweise Duodenalver- schliisse und ihre Behandlung. 24p. 8? Tub [n. pub.] 1933. HAUG, Karl, 1903- *Ueber den Einfluss des Spinates auf die Magensekretion. p.20-43 8? Berl., S. Karger, 1929. Aluo Arch. Verdauungskr., 1929, 45: ---- Die Storungen des Personlichkeitsbe- wusstseins und verwandte Entfremdungserleb- nisse; eine klinische und psychologische Studie vi, 21 lp. 8? Stuttg., F. Enke, 1936. ---- Depersonalisation und verwandte Er- scheinungen. p. 134-204. 25}£cm. Berl., J. Springer, 1939. In Handb. Geisteskrankh. (O. Bumke) Ergiinzbd, T. 1. HAUG, Karl, 1909- *Ueber Probeaus- schneidungen ausGewebsneubildungen der Mund- hohle an Hand eigener Beobachtungen [Miin- chen] 30p. 8? Augsb., H. Heber, 1934. HAUG, Roman, 1906- *Lepra in Wiirt- temberg; medizinisch-historischer Uoberblick bis zum 17. Jahrhundert. 16p. 8? Tiib., Schwabenverl., 1935. HAUG, Ulrich, 1909- *Ueber die Heilungs- aussichten der Pleuraempyeme im Kindesalter. 27p. 8? Tub., A. Becht, 1933. HAUGHTON, H. O. What better than serum? 12p. 8? [Bait., n. pub., 1902] HAUGHWOUT, Frank G. The practical microscopic diagnosis of dysentery. 130p. 20 pl. 8? Manila, Bur. Print., 1924. Forms Bull. No. 3 Inst. Med. Res. Fed. Malay States, 1924. HAUGWITZ, Elfriede, 1907- *Ueber die Morbiditat und Mortalitat bei kiinstlicher Schwangerschaftsunterbrechung. 19p. 8? Konigsb., J. Raabe, 1935. HAUK [Karl] Bernhard, 1910- *Ueber die Kinngrosse und deren Verhaltnis zur Zahn- bogenlange des Unterkiefers [Leipzig] 27p. 8? Zeulenroda i. Thiir., A. Oberreuter, 1935. HAUKE, Giinter, 1909- *Ein Beitrag zur Bestrahlung aleukamischer Lymphadenosen. 16p. 8? Bresl., Breslauer Genossensch. Buchdr., 1934. HAUKE, Ignazio. Nuovi apparati pneumatici e loro applicazione nella pratica delle malattie dei bambini. 48p. 24cm. Trieste, B. Appolonio, 1877. HAUKE, James. History of a pair of eyes. 45p. 8? N. Y., Trow Directory, Print. & Bookbinding Co., 1895. HAUKOHL, Robert S. *The causes of right ventricular hypertrophy and failure, with particu- lar reference to pulmonary diseases [Milwaukee Co. Hosp.] 21p. 28cm. [Wauwatosa] 1940. Typewritten. HAUKSBEE, Francis, 1687-1763. Crane, A. W. Francis Hauksbee: did he, in 1709, see his hand through sealing-wax and pitch? (with a repetition of the experiments) Am. J. Roentg., 1933, 29: 671-87. HAULTAIN, William Francis Theodore, 1893- A practical handbook of midwifery and gynaecology for students and practitioners, viii, 316p. 8? Lond., Faber & Gwyer, 1926. ---- & FAHMY, E. Chalmers. Ante-natal care; a practical handbook of ante-natal care and of abnormalities associated with pregnancy, xi, 113p. 3 fold, sheets. 12? Edinb., E. & S. Livingstone, 1929. HAULTAIN, William Francis Theodore & KENNEDY, Clifford. A practical handbook of midwifery and gynaecology for students and practitioners. 2. ed. x, 356p. illust. pl. 8? Edinb., E. & S. Livingstone, 1935. HAUMANN, Heinz, 1908- *Ueber den Einfluss von Schlafmitteln auf die alkoholische Garung [Munster] 17p. 21J4cm. Dortmund, E. Arnold, 1936. HAUMANN, Paul [Heinrich] 1908- *Ueber die Verwendung der Saccharose und des Adonits in Plattennahrboden zur Erkennung und Unterscheidung von Bakterien aus der Inter- medins- und Paratyphus-Enteritis-Gruppe bei der bakteriologischen Fleischbeschau [Giessen] 28p. 10 tab, 23^cm. Berl., R. Pfau, 1939. HAMUANN 103 HAUPTMANN HAUMANN, Walter, 1891- Die Wirbel- briiche und ihre Endergebnisse. 2 1. 180p. 8? Stuttg., F. Enke, 1930. HAUN, Friedrich, 1883- ♦Strafe fiir Psychopathen? [Munchen] v, 125p. 8? Strau- bing, C. Attenkofer, 1928. HAUNFELDER, David, 1912- ♦Bak- teriophagen im Speichel Mundkranker [Wiirz- burg] 15p. 8? Roth-Nurnb., K. Muller, 1936. HAUNGS, Gerda, 1909- *Genealogische Untersuchungen in einem Inzuchtsgebiet [Heidel- berg] 18p. 8? Borna, R. Noske, 1938. HAUPELTSHOFER, Hans, 1910- ♦Erb- liche Falle von Pseudosklerose unter besonderer Beriicksichtigung des Kayser-Fleischer'schen Hornhautringes als Friihdiagnose. 23p. 21cm. [Erlangen, n. pub.] 1938. HAUPT, Arthur W[ing] 1894- Funda- mentals of biology, xii, 358p. 8? N. Y., Mc- Graw-Hill Book Co., 1928. Also 3. ed., 2. im- pression, xii, 443p. illust. diagr. 23^cm. N. Y., McGraw-Hill Book Co., 1940. ----Laboratory directions for general biology 3. ed. ix, 65p. 23>km. N. Y., McGraw-Hill Book Co., 1940. HAUPT, Bernhard, 1900- ♦Kasuistische Beitrage zur Klinik der Bangbakterien-Infektion. 39p. ch. 8? Konigsb., J. Raabe, 1931. HAUPT, Gertrud, 1896- ♦Bircher-Ben- ner-Diat und Sauerbruch-Herrmannsdorfer-Ger- son-Diat. 28p. 8? Giessen, O. Kindt, 1931. HAUPT, Heinrich, 1903- ♦Zur Kenntnis der Epidermolysis bullosa hereditaria. 29p. 8? Gott., Gott. Handelsdr., 1933. HAUPT, Heinrich [Herbert] 1908- ♦Die Wirkung des Recvalysatum Burger bei opera- tiven Eingriffen in der Mundhohle. lOp. 8? Heidelb. [n. pub.] 1931. HAUPT, Herbert,' & RASCHKE, Otto. Tech- nik der spezifischen Diagnostik und Therapie der Haustierseuchen. viii, 253p. 4 pl. 8? Witten- berg, Gebr. Bischoff, 1925. HAUPT, Hugo. See Fnchss, Heinrich, Bruns, Hayo, & Haupt, Hugo. Die Bleivergiftungsgefahr durch Leitungswasser. 93p. 8? Dresd., 1938. HAUPT, Kathe, 1911- ♦Quantitative Serumglobulin-Bestimmungen bei Tuberkulosen vor und nach der Pneumothoraxbehandlung [Tiibingen] 23p. 8? Boblingen, W. Schlecht, 1937. HAUPT, Karl, 1904- ♦Die Aufnahme- technik des Hundeelektrokardiogramms in der Veterinarklinik und ihre Ergebnisse [Giessen] 2 1. 28p. 8? Bad Wildungen, E. Funk, 1929. HAUPT, Kurt [Oskar Johannes] 1910- ♦Beitrag zur operativen Behandlung der habi- tuellen Patellarluxation. 27p. 8? Giessen, F. Linke, 1936. HAUPT, Lothar [Artur] 1913- ♦Die Teleskopkrone als Befestigungs- und Stiitz- (dement der partiellen Prothese. 24p. 8? Lpz., A. Edelmann, 1937. HAUPT, Ursula, 1911- ♦Ein Fall von prasenilem Beeintrachtigungswahn. 26p. 22^cm. Berl., H. Michel, 1939. HAUPT, Werner, 1908- ♦Die Abhangig- keit des Hefewachstums vom Zuckergehalt des Nahrbodens [Munster] 12p. 8? Diisseld., G. H. Nolte, 1934. HAUPT, Willi, 1911- ♦Der kurzgeheizte Kautschuk fiir die Prothese [Freiburg] 23p. 23J/2cm. Berl., Marki, 1937. HAUPTMANN, Herbert, 1909- *Unter welchen Bedingungen verschwinden auch letzte Cadmiumreste aus den Einbettungsmassen? Up. 8? Greifsw., H. Adler, 1936. HAUPTMANN, Karl, 1904- ♦Unter- suchungen krankhaft veranderter Haut mit dem Wood'schen Licht-Filter [Erlangen] 26p 8° Kallmiinz, M. Lassleben, 1933. HAUPTMANN [Otto] Fritz, 1891- ♦Die Tierhaltung des deutschen Mittelalters im Lichte des Sachsenspiegels. 42p. 8? Lpz., A. Edel- mann, 1931. HAURADOU, Olympe Louis Raphael, 1883- ♦Anevrysmes arteno-veineux intra-cra- niens; etude sur revolution de 4 cas longtemps suivis et gueris spontanement. 69p. 8? Par , M. Vigne, 1931. HAURAND, Karl, 1908- ♦Beitrag zur Klinik der aregeneratorischen (aplastischen) Anamie im Sauglingsalter [Munster] 20p. 21cm. Bochum, H. Poppinghaus, 1935. HAUROWITZ, Felix. Biochemie des Men- schen und der Tiere seit 1914. xii, 148p. 8° Dresd., T. Steinkopff, 1925. Form Bd 12, Wissenschaftl. Forschungsber. Naturwissen- schaftliche Reihe. HAURY, Jean, 1898- ♦Le traitement de la tuberculose pulmonaire par les voyages au long cours. 52p. 8? Par., Jouve & cie, 1927. HAUS, Paul, 1908- ♦Die Versorgung der Nabelschnur. 23p. 8? Wiirzb., R. Mayr, 1934. HAUS, Rudolf, 1910- ♦Die Schadlich- keit der Mundatmung mit besonderer Beriick- sichtigung der Zahnkaries und Gaumenbildung [Munchen] 19p. 8? Wiirzb., R. Mayr, 1935. HAUSAM, Georg Friedrich, 1910- ♦Ein Beitrag zur Frage der Konstruktion des Briicken- korpers [Breslau] 41p. 8? Neumarkt i. Schles., K. Groda, 1933. HAUSAM, Willi, 1905- ♦Untersu- chungen fiber Bakterium coli; ein Beitrag zur Kenntnis der Milch-Colibakterien und zur Erforschung ihres Lebenszyklus [Kiel] 78p. 2 1. 14 pl. 8? Borna, R. Noske, 1930. HAUSAMEN, Erich Heinrich, 1907- ♦Ueber akute Osteomyelitis des Unterkiefers. 24p. 8? Berl., R. Bruckhoff, 1932. HAUSCHILD, Felix [Peter Louis Anton] 1884- ♦Ueber die ruhende Infektion nach Kriegsschussverletzungen der Knochen und ihre Begutachtung [Berlin] 34p. 8? Charlottenb., Gebr. Hoffmann, 1936. HAUSCHILD, Max Wolfgang, 1883-1924. Grundriss der Anthropologic viii, 235p. roy. 8? Berl., Gebr. Borntraeger, 1926. HAUSCHILDT, Claus Walter, 1905- ♦Ergebnisse der konservativen Behandlung des medialen Schenkelhalsbruchs an der Kieler Chirurgischen Universitats-Klinik aus den Jahren 1918-33 tKiel] 15p. 8? Wiirzb., K. Triltsch, 1935. HAUSDOERFER, Herbert, 1897- ♦Ver- gleichende Acetonkorper- und Bilirubinbestim- mungen im Blut bei Icterus-Kranken. 21p. 8? Bresl., Schles. Volkszeitung, 1930. HAUSE, Edward E. ♦Korsakow's psychosis [S. Francisco Co. Hosp.] 16p. 28cm. S. Franc, 1940. Typewritten. HAUSE, Erich, 1902- ♦Ueber einen seltenen Fall von Mastitis gangrenosa [Leipzig] 12p. 8? Oschatz, C. Morgner, 1927. HAUSER, Alfred. ♦Ueber die Resultate nach operativer und konservativer Behandlung der Meniscusverletzungen bei der Schweizerischen Unfallversicherung [Zurich] 48p. 8? Kling- nau, K. Biirli, 1925. HAUSER 104 HAUSER HAUSER, Benjamin Gayelord. Child feed- ing, written for mothers, vii, 130p. portr. 8? N. Y., Tempo Books, Inc. [1932] ---- Health day (Gesundheitstag) the one- day-a-week health" holiday as introduced in America. 4 p. 1. 57p. portr. 8? N. Y"., Tempo Books, Inc. [1932] ---- Keener vision without glasses. 162p. 8? X. Y., Tempo Rooks, Inc. [1932] HAUSER, Emil Daniel William, 1897- Diseases of the foot, xv, 472p. illust. pl. 24cm. Phila., W. B. Saunders Co., 1939. HAUSER, Ernst Alfred, 1896- Colloidal phenomena; an introduction to the science of colloids. xx, 294p. illust, diagr. 23>km. N. Y., McGraw-Hill Book Co., 1939. HAUSER, Eugen [Gustav] 1911- ♦Ence- phalomyelitis nach Diphtherie [Heidelberg] 25p. S? Erlangen-Bruck, M. Krahl, 1938. HAUSER, F. Das Arbeiten mit auffallendem Licht in der Mikroskopie, Mikro- und Makro- photographie. p.3717-849. 25cm. Berl., Urban & Schwarzenberg, 1939. In Handb. biol. Arbeitsmeth. (E. Abderhalden) Abt. 2, T. 3, 2. Halfte. HAUSER, Francois, 1912- ♦Les reac- tions perverses chez les enfants. 48p. 24cm. Par., M. Vigne, 1939. HAUSER, Franz, 1905- ♦Atypischer Lichen ruber planus der Mundschleimhaut. 27p. 8? Freib. i. B., K. Schillinger, 1931. HAUSER, Gustav, 1856-1935. [Autobiography] Med. Gegenwart (Grote) Lpz., 1927, 6: 141-204, portr.—Busch, M. Gustav Hauser zum 70. Ge- burtstag. Deut. med. Wschr., 1926, 52: 1180.—Kirch, E. Nekrolog. Zbl. allg. Path., 1935, 63: 369-73.—Merkel, H. Zu Gustav Hauscrs 70. Geburtstag. Miinch. med. Wschr., 1926, 73: 1164-6, portr. HAUSER, Hilde, 1904- *Joseph Serva- tius von d'Outrepout, Professor der Geburts- hiilfe und Frauenheilkunde in Wriirzburg (1775- 1845) 38p. S? [Wurzb., n. pub.] 1927. HAUSER, Josef Fridolin, 1911- ♦Weitere Beitrage zur Friihdiagnose der Trachtigkeit beim Rind [Zurich] 60p. 12 tab. 8? Kling- nau, K. Biirli, 1937. HAUSER, K. Ernst Haeckel; sein Leben, sein Wirken und seine Bedeutung fiir den Geisteskampf der Gegenwart. 147p. 8? Godes- berg, Naturwiss. Verl., 1920. HAUSER, Karl, 1866- Vollenweider, P. Oberfeldarzt Oberst Dr Hauser anliisslich seines Riicktrittes gewidmet. Schweiz. med. Wschr., 1936, 66: 133, portr. HAUSER, Karl Jakob, 1911- ♦Genealo- gie und erbbiologische Bestandesaufnahme eines Inzuehtdorfes der Sudostschweiz [Zurich] 62p. ch. 22}£cm. Schaffhausen, Freudenfels, 1940. HAUSER, Kaspar, 1812-33. Brunner. E. Kaspar Hauser? Zschr. Menschenk., 1929-30, 5: 343-408, 4 pl., 4 ch. HAUSER, Otto, 1874- ♦Ueber eine neue Chronologie des mittleren Palaolithikums im V6zeretal speziell mit Bezug auf meine Aus- grabungen auf la Micoque [Erlangen] 56p. 9 1. 10 pl. 4? Lpz., Veit & Co., 1916. ---- Rasselehre. 130p. 12? Brnschw., G. Westermann, 1925. ---- Rasse und Gesundheit. 144p. 12? Brnschw., G. Westermann, 1925. ---- Vom Urmenschen und seiner Welt zum Menschen der Gegenwart. 70p. tab. 8° Lpz., F. E. Wachsmuth, 1926. HAUSER, Paul, 1909- ♦Beitrage zu den Ursachen der unangenehmen Nebenwirkungen in der Lokalanasthesie [Munchen] 20p. 8° Wiirzb., R. Mayr, 1933. HAUSER, Philip Morris, 1909- See Blumer, Herbert, & Hauser, P. M. Movies, delin- quency, and crime. 233p. s.' N. Y., 1933. HAUSER, Rudolf, 1909- ♦Ueber die bosartigen epithelialen Schilddrusengeschwulste unter besonderer Berucksichtigung des Schild- driisenkrebses. 27p. 2 ch. 22cm. Heidelb., H. Meister, 1936. HAUSER, Saul, 1911- ♦Die Bedeutung des Zweistundenwcrtes der Senkungs-Reaktion nach Westergren. 18p. 8? Berl., R. Pfau, 1937. HAUSER, Walter. ♦Krebs und Unfall. 64p. 8? Tiib. [n. pub.] 1933. HAUSER-HOELKEN, Maja, 1899- ♦Er- folge der chirurgischen Behandlung und der Rontgentherapie der bosartigen Nierengeschwul- ste im Kindesalter. 22p. 8? Berl. [n. pub.] 1928. HAUSHALTER, Paul, 1860-1925. Inauguration du monument k la m^moire du professor Haushalter. Rev. meU est, 1927, 55: 337-49.—Perrin, M. Neurologic. Rev. m<§d. fr., 1925, 6: 263. HAUSHOFER, Max. Bevolkerungslehre. vi, 128p. 12? Lpz., B. G. Teubner, 1904. Forms 50. Bd, Aus Natur und Geisteswelt. HAUSKNECHT, Karl, 1910- ♦Ueber die verschiedenen Methoden der Sterilisation. 30p. 21cm. Wiirzb., Gebr. Memminger, 1937. HAUSKNECHT, Salomon, 1905- ♦Traitement des gastrorragies graves par la resection h^mostatique d'urgence accompagnee d'appendico-coecostomie temporaire et de chasse coecocolique immediate. 68p. 8? Par., Jouve & cie, 1933. HAUSLADEN, Wolfgang, 1909- ♦Krebs- statistik nach den Befunden des Pathologischen Instituts zu Munchen von 1922-1931 nebst kurzer Uebersicht der anderen in derselben Zeitperiode vorgekommenen bosartigen Geschwiil- ste. 40p. 8? Munchen, K. J. Schwarz, 1934. HAUSLER, Schaje, 1902- ♦L'oblitera- tion et le r6tr6cissement du canal sous-aortique. 47p. 8? Par., M. Vigne, 1929. HAUSLEUTNER, Kurt, 1909- ♦Ueber die Blutgruppenbestimmung aus dem Harn und aus Harnflecken [Breslau] 33p. 8? Ohlau, H. Eschenhagen, 1934. HAUSLICH, Stefanie, 1912- ♦Les infil- trats tertiaires pr^coces. 90p. 25}£cm. Tr6- voux, G. Patissier, 1939. HAUSMAN, Louis, 1891- See Sachs, Bernard, & Hausman, L. Nervous and mental disorders [[etc.] 861p. 8? N. Y., 1926. HAUSMANN, Hans, 1900- ♦Ein Beitrag zur Versorgung des offenen Pneumothorax. 28p. 8? Wiirzb., C. J. Becker, 1926. HAUSMANN, Hans, 1908- ♦Zusammen- hange zwischen eosinophil-granulierten Leuko- cyten im peripheren Blut, im Knochenmark und entziindeten Gewebe (Studien an hyper- ergischen Meerschweinchen) p.511-35. 8? Berl. [n. pub.] 1935. Also Zschr. ges. exp. Med., 1932, 85: HAUSMANN, Theodor, 1868- Metho- dologie des Tastens. p. 1105-73. 8? Berl., 1937. 1937%"ri^Tb7,2.H^fete?meth- (Abderhalden> E"> BerL' HAUSMANN, Walther, 1877-1938. Grund- zuge der Lichtbiologie und Lichtpathologie. iooQ231p- 8? BerL' Urban & Schwarzenberg, Forms Bd 8, Strahlentherap. (W. Falta [et al.]) For biography see Ann. Inst, actin., Par., 1937-38 12: 97. —— & HAXTHAUSEN, H. Die Lichter- krankungen der Haut. xi, 130p. 8? Berl Urban & Schwarzenberg, 1929. HAUSMANN 105 HAUTEFEUILLE HAUSMANN, Walther, & VOLK, R. Hand- buch der Lichttherapie. 3 p. 1. • 444p. 8? Wien, J. Springer, 1927. HAUSMANN, Wilhelm. ♦Zur Differential- diagnose der Pulmonalsklerose. 20p. 8? Miinch., F. X. Seitz, 1935. HAUSNER, Franz, 1909- ♦Dermoid- zyste, Schwangerschaft und Geburt [Munchen] 32p. 8? Diisseld., G. H. Nolte, 1933. HAUSOLD, Irmgard, 1913- ♦Der Hamo- globingehalt gesunder Manner und Frauen in Mitteldeutschland, eine Grundlage zur Defini- tion des relativen MafJsystems der Hamo- globinbestimmung und zur Berechnung des normalen Farbeindex [Jena] 27p. 21cm. Bottrop, W. Postberg, 1936. HAUSS, Adolf, 1911- ♦Ueber die Ent- stehung des Lupus per contiguitatem [Munster] 15p. 8? Bottrop, W. Postberg, 1937. HAUSS, Richard, 1902- ♦Ueber Menis- kus-Verletzungen [Heidelberg] 32p. 8? Koln, Z. Beckmann, 1926. HAUSSEN, Hans Otto von, 1902- ♦Ueber die relative Lage des Kiefergelenkes am Schadel derPrimaten [Frankfurt] p.465-97. 8? Stuttg., E. Schweizerbart, 1931. Also Zschr. Morph. Anthrop., 1931, 29: HAUSSER, Guy, 1912- ♦Le medecin- expert et la revision en matiere d'accidents du travail [Paris] 193p. 8? Rouen, Imp. Wolf, 1936. HAUSSER, Karl Wilhelm, 1887-1933. Strah- lung und Lichterythem. 3 1. 89p. illust. diagrs. 8? Lpz., Akad. Verlagsges., 1934. HAUSSER, Rudolf, 1910- ♦Lokalanas- thesie und Lipoidloslichkeit. 16p. 8? Tiib., Bolze, 1936. HAUSSKNECHT, Karl, 1838-1903. Branco, K. Apotheker Karl Haussknecht zum Gedachtnis. Deut. Heilpflanze, 1938-39, 5: 17. HAUSSLEITER, Johannes, 1893- Der Vegetarismus in der Antike. 3 1. [v]-viii, 427p. 8? Berl., A. Topelmann, 1935. HAUSTEIN, Hans, 1894-1933. Zur sexuellen Hygiene in Sowjet-Russland. 41p. 8? Bonn, A. Marcus & E. Weber, 1926. Forms Heft 1, v.5, Abh. a. d. Geb. d. Sexforsch. For portrait, photograph see collection in library. HAUSTEIN, Manfred, 1908- ♦Primarer Wundverschluss bei offenen Frakturen langer Rohrenknochen [Halle] 20p. 8? Zeulenroda, A. Oberreuter [1934] HAUSTHIER (Der) fiir den amerikanischen Farmer und Biehziichter. xvi, 375p. 8? Mil- waukee, Wis., G. Brumder, 1881. HAUSWALD, Herbert, 1908- *Ueber Fettembolie nach Frakturen [Leipzig] 34p. 8? Zeulenroda, A. Oberreuter, 1934. HAUSWIRTH, Alfred. ♦Die chirurgische Behandlung der Varicocele. 47p. 8? Bern, Neukomm & Zimmermann, 1905. HAUTANT, Aflbert] & CAUSSE, R. Hygiene du sourd. xiii, 82p. 12? Par., G. Doin, 1933. HAUTCOEUR, Paul, 1871- ♦Essai de prophylaxie de la tuberculose bovine par le B. C. G. dans une exploitation de l'arrondisse- ment de Cambrai [Alfort] 78p. 8? Par., Vigot freres, 1934. HAUTEFEUILLE, Edouard, 1896- ♦Con- tribution a l'etude de la granulie froide et chronique. 64p. pl. 8? Par., Impr. Cour d'Appel, 1926. HAUTEFEUILLE, Jean de, 1647-1724. Pro- bleme d'acoustique curieux et interessant, dont la solution est proposee aux savans, d'apres les id6es qu en a laissees M. l'Abbe" de Hautefeuille. xxxii, 117p. 8? Par., Varin, 1788. HAUTESSERRE, Maurice, 1911- ♦Re- cherches sur un principe vaso-constricteur du genet a balai et son action adrenalinique [Alfort] 41p. 8? Lyon, Bose freres, 1937. HAUTH, Walter, 1911- ♦Ueber den Leukocytenbefund im Magensaft bei chronischer Gastritis. 85p. 20^cm. Bonn, A. Brand, 1938. HAUTTEMENT, Pierre, 1907- ♦A pro- pos d'un cas ine"dit de contusion du pancreas; les fistules post-operatoires. 58p. 8? Par. Vigot freres, 1934. HAUZINGER, Alfons, 1904- ♦Ueber chronischeErfrierungsschaden. 14p. 8? Munch., C. Wolf & Sohn, 1932. HAVARD, Valery, 1846-1927. Sanitation and yellow fever in Havana; report. 15p. 8° [n. p., 1901.] ---- The venereal peril, lip. 8? [n. p., n. pub., 190-] For biography see J. Am. M. Ass., 1928, 90: 709. HAVAS, Gina, 1906- ♦Ein Fall von Osler'scher Krankheit [Berlin] 18p. 8? Jena, G. Neuenhahn, 1933. HAVE, Johannes Theodorus ten, 1877-1935. [Obituary] Geneesk. gids, 1935, 13: 504, portr. HAVE, Paul Antoine, 1903- ♦Sages- femmes et 6cole d'accouchement a Colmar [Strasbourg] 34p. 3 pl. 24}£cm. Colmar, Alsatia, 1934. HAVELAND, Ruth, 1900- ♦Zur Patho- genese und Therapie der Hirschsprungschen Krankheit an Hand von zehn an der Universitats- Kinderklinik zu Breslau beobachteten Fallen 19p. 8? Bresl., L. Freund, 1927. HAVEN, Marc. La vie et les oeuvres de maitre Arnaud de Villeneuve. 192p. 2 1. 8° Par., Chamuel, 1896. ---- Le maitre inconnu, Cagliostro; 6tude historique et critique sur la haute magie [2. e\L] 2 p. 1. iii-vii, 330p. illust. pl. portr. 8? Par., Pythagore, 1932. HAVENS, Leon Clive, 1891-1933. The bacteriology of typhoid, Salmonella, and dysen- tery infections and carrier states, xii, 158p. illust. diagrs. 8? N. Y., Commonwealth Fund, 1935. HAVENSTEIN, Fritz, 1897- ♦Ein Fall von schnellgewachsenem sehr grossem Chy- langioma cavernosum im Diinndarmmesenterium. 27p. 8? Bonn, L. Neuendorf!, 1926. HAVER, Friedrich [Ludwig Joachim Christian] 1891- ♦Beitrag zur pathologischen Anato- mie und Aetiologie des Keratokonus. 32p. Rostock, C. Hinstorff, 1919. HAVER, Horstmar, 1913- ♦Ueber die Verwendbarkeit chemischer Nachweismethoden bei Kohlenoxydblut [Wurzburg] 24p. 21cm. Altenb.-Thiir., S. Geibel & Co., 1938. HAVERFIELD, M. Elna W. Enlightened woman, viii, 156p. 8? Chic, G. S. Cline & Co., 1882. HAVERHILL, Mass. Board of Health. Annual report. Haverhill, 2.-56., 1881-1935. HAVERHILL, Mass. Board of Water Com- missioners. Annual report. Haverhill, 38., 1929- HAVERHILL, Mass. City Hospital. Annual reports. Haverhill, 1.-10., 1888-97. HAVERHILL, Mass., Hale Hospital. Annual Reports. Haverhill, v. 12-15; 1899-1902. Incomplete. HAVERHILL HAVERHILL fever. See Acrodynia; Erythema. HAVERS, Joseph, 1909- ♦Ueber eine eigenartige Knochenhbhlenerkrankung ahnlich einer Ostitis fibrosa generalisata. 16p. 8? Wiirzb., R. Mayr, 1937. HAVERSCHMIDT, Jacob, 1862-1938. Carstens, J. H. G. [Obituary] Mschr. kindergeneesk., 1938-39, 8: 1-4. HAVERSIAN canal. See Bone, Mechanics. HAVERSTRAW, N. Y. New York State Hospital for Crippled and Deformed Children. Annual report. Haverstraw, 1916-17; 1922. HAVET, Gilbert Paul Louis, 1898- ♦Con- tribution a l'etude de la piroplasmose canine [Alfort] 53p. 8? Chartres, Impr. Durand, 1930. HAVET, Jean, 1909- ♦L'hemophilie et son traitement par les vitamines. 44p. 8? Par., Vigot freres, 1937. HAVEY, I. Malinde, 1887-1938. Obituary. Red Cross Courier, 1938-39, 18: No. 4, 9, portr. HAVIL, Anthony. The technique of sex; towards a better understanding of sexual rela- tionship [3. impression] 120p. diagr. 19cm. Lond., Wales Pub. Co. [1939] HAVILAND, C. Floyd, 1875-1930. Obituary. Arch. Neur. Psychiat., Chic, 1930, 23: 546, portr. Also Ment. Hyg., Alb., 1930, 14: 161-4. Also Psychiat. Q., 1930, 4: 168-71, portr. HAVKIN, Uri, 1913- ♦Le traitement des vomissements gravidiques parletubage duodenal. 56p. 8° Lyon, Impr. R. Gauthier, 1937. HAVRET, Henri, 1902- ♦L'ictere physio- logique du nouveau-n6. 68p. 8? Par., A. Lerand, 1930. HAWAII, U. S. Board of Health. Annual report. Honolulu, 1876-1930; 1933- HAWAll, U. S. Board of Hospitals and Settle- ment. Annual report. Honolulu, 1937-1940. HAWAII, U. S. Governor. Annual report. Wash., 1900/1- HAWAII, U. S. University of Hawaii. Bulle- tin. Honolulu, v.15, No. 6, 1936. ---- Publications; catalogue and announce- ments of courses. Honolulu, 1916-22. ---- Quarterly bulletin; register of officers and students and abridged announcement of courses. Honolulu, 1921-36. ---- Research publications. Honolulu, No. 1, 1927; No. 13, 1936; No. 15, 1937; No. 18, 1938. Issued as part of University of Hawaii Bulletin. HAWAII, U. S. See also Honolulu. Hawaii, U. S. Governor. Annual report. Honolulu, 1901- Fowke, G. Archeological work in Hawaii. Smithson. Inst. Bur. Am. Ethnol., 1922, Bull. 76, 174-95, 4 pl.—Green, L. S., & Beckwith, M. W. Hawaiian household customs. Am. Anthrop., 1928, 30: 1-17.—Handy, E. S. C. Dreaming in relation to spirit kindred and sickness in Hawaii. In Essays Anthrop. (A. L. Kroeber) Berkeley, 1936, 119-28.—Lind, A. W. Assimilation in rural Hawaii. Am. J. Sociol., 1939-40, 45: 200-14.—Masuoka, J. Race preference in Hawaii. Ibid., 1935-36, 41: 635-41.—Racial factors in the Hawaiian labor situation. J. Hered., 1941, 32: 17.—Smith, W. C. The hybrid in Hawaii as a marginal man. Am. J. Sociol., 1934, 39: 459-68. ---- Medical aspect. Briggs, L. V. Experiences of a medical student in Honolulu, and on the Island of Oahu, 1881. 251p. 8? Bost., 1926. Hiscock, I. V. A survey of public health activities in Honolulu, Hawaii. 149p. 8? N. Haven, 1935 HAWAII Bin ford, C. H. The history and study of leprosy in Hawaii. Pub. Health Rep., Wash., 1936, 51: 415-23—Ferre, G. Plantation surgery; a survey of the statistics of 1934. Tr. Hawaii M. Ass., 1935, 45: 57-62.—Goodhue, h. S. Doctoring in Hawaii. Am. J. Clin. M., 1911, 18: 299 301.—Hiscock, I. V. Health work on a sugar plantation in Hawaii. Am. J. Pub. Health, 1936, 26: 865-71.—Keay, T. The plantation physician. Tr. Hawaii M. Ass., 1938, No. 48, 78.—Kung, H. W. Life tables for various racial groups in Hawaii. Am. J. Hyg., 1926, 6: 74-118.—Midkiff, F. E. Health in Hawaii where East and West meet. Med. Woman J., 1940, 47: 213-21.—Territoire d'Hawaii; population, natalite, mortality gen6rale et par certaines causes de diets (ann6es 1925 k 1935) Bull. Off. internat. hyg. pub., Par., 1937, 29: 2160. [Hawaii] Medical Society of Hawaii. (Formerly called Hawaii Territorial Medical Association) Hawaii Territorial Medical Association. Honolulu. Transactions. 1. meet., 1926- Arnold, H. L. President's address. Tr. Hawaii M. Ass., 1939, 49: 22-5.—Dunn, W. T. President's address. Ibid., 1940, 50: 23-5.—Membership list. Ibid., 147-50.—Officers, standing committees, minutes of meeting, etc. Ibid., 1939, 49: 1; 1940, 50: p. i. HAWAII Territorial Medical Association. Transactions of the. Honolulu, 1. Meet., 1926- HAWAII Territorial Medical Association and Pacific Coast Surgeons. See Pan-Pacific Surgical Conference. Proceedings. Hono- lulu, 1. Conf., 1929. HAWES, Alfred Taylor, 1874- Talks to first year nurses. 191p. 8? Bost., Whitcomb & Barrows, 1907. HAWES, John B. A study of Tait's perineor- rhaphy. 6p. 8? Reichenberg [n. pub.] 1888. HAWES, John Bromham, 2d, 1887-1938. Consumption; what it is and what to do about it. 3. ed. viii, 113p. 8? Bost., Small, Maynard & Co. [1926] ---- You and the doctor, xv, 181p. 19}^cm. Bost., Houghton Mifflin Co. [1929] ---- Talks on tuberculosis with patients and their friends, x, 179p. 8? Bost., Houghton Mifflin Co., 1931. ----& STONE, Moses Jacob. The diagnosis and treatment of pulmonary tuberculosis; a handbook for practitioners; a text-book for students, nurses and social workers. 215p. illust. diagr. 20^cm. Phila., Lea & Febiger [1936] Also 2. ed., rev. 260p. illust. diagr. [1940] HAWICKHORST, Heinrich, 1910- ♦Die Wirkung der Ultra-Violett-Lichtbestrahlung auf den Stoffwechsel des Korpers, der mit Casein oder Maiskleber und gleichzeitig vitaminarm ernahrt wird. 15p. 23cm. BerL, R. Pfau, 1936. HAWICKHORST, Werner, 1911- ♦Bei- trag zur Therapie der Extrauteringraviditat. 35p. 8? Halle, E. Klinz, 1936. HAWK, Philip Bovier, 1874- The in- fluence of hemorrhage upon metabolism. 73p. 1. 12? Easton, Pa., Chem. Pub. Co., 1905. ---- Practical physiological chemistry; a book designed for use in courses in practical physiological chemistry in schools of medicine and of science. 6. ed., rev. and enl. xiv, 661p. illust. 6 pl. 24cm. Phila., P. Blakiston's Son & Co. [1918] Also 7. ed., rev. xiv, 675p. illust. 6 pl. [1921] Also 9. ed., with Olaf Bergeim. xviii, 931p. 8 pl. [1926] Also 10. ed., with Olaf Bergeim. xviii, 929p. 8 pl. [1931] Also 11. ed., with Olaf Bergeim. xxii, 968p. illust. pl. diagrs. [1937] ---- What we eat and what happens to it, the results of the first direct method ever devised to follow the actual digestion of food in the human stomach. 7 p. 1. 23lp. 19Kcm. N Y Harper & Brothers [1919] HAWK 107 HAXTHAUSEN ---- Streamline for health. xviii, 186p. illust. pl. diagrs. 8? N. Y., Harper & bros, 1935. HAWKES, A. W. The public and a program for industrial harmony. 18p. 22cm. [N.Y., Nat. Ass. Manuf., 1939] ---- Who can preserve representative de- mocracy? 24p. 21>2cm. [N. Y., Nat. Ass. Manuf.] 1939. HAWKINS, Arthur Hanson, 1868- Sharrett, G. O. The man: Arthur H. Hawkins, M. D. Bull. School M. Univ. Maryland, 1933, 18: 58-62. HAWKINS, Charles Lewis, 1870-1939. Obituary. Tr. West. Soc. Am. Urol. Ass., 1939, 8: p. v, portr. HAWKINS, Harold Fuller. Applied nutrition. 3 p. 1. v-viii, 195p. diagr. 22}km. N. Y., A. S. Barnes & Co. [1940] HAWORTH, Norah A., & MACDONALD, E. Mary. Theory of occupational therapy; for students and nurses, ix, 132p. illust. 8 pl. 22^cm. Lond., Bailliere, Tindall & Cox, 1940. HAWTHORNE, Charles Oliver. Short essays on medical topics, iv, 246p. 12? Lond., J. Bale, sons & Danielsson, 1928. [HAWTHORNE, Diana] The standard home doctor; an alphabetical list of diseases, their symptoms, treatment and cures, given in plain language, with commonsense advice telling what to do in emergencies and how to do it. 310p. 8? Lond., T. Werner Laurie [1937] HAWTHORNE, Joseph Wyman. A group test for the measurement of cruelty-compassion: a proposed means of recognizing potential criminality. p. 189-211. 8? Chic, Univ. Chicago, 1932. HAX, Dora, 1902- ♦Die chemischen Veranderungen des Gesamtorganismus und der Organe im Verlauf der postuterinen Entwicklung [Bonn] p.627-39. 8? Berl., J. Springer, 1927. Also Arch. ges. Physiol., 1927, 216: HAXTHAUSEN, Holger. ♦Hudsygdomme fremkaldt af lyset [Skin diseases caused by light] 242p. 9 pl. 8? Kbh., P. Branner, 1919. ~ Cold in relation to skin diseases. 163p. 10 pl. 8. Kbh., Levin & Munksgaard, 1930. See also Hausmann, Walther, & Haxthausen, H. Die Licnterkrankungen der Haut. 130p. 8? Berl., 1929. HAY, Alfred. Photographisches Praktikum fiir Mediziner und Naturwissenschaftler. x, 531p 8? Wien, J. Springer, 1930. See also Leiter, F., & Hay, A. Leitfaden zur Behandlung und Bewertung von Kystoskopen und deren Optik. 39n. 8° Lpz., 1923. HAY, James. Medical marvels in our army. p.259-64. [N. Y., 1916] From Munsey's Mag., N. Y., 1916, 59: HAY, 0[liver] P[erry] 1846- The red- headed woodpecker as a hoarder. p. 193-6. 8? [n. p., 1887] Cutting from Auk, 1887, 4: HAY, Percy Douglas, 1899- The neck; a roentgenological study of the soft tissues; consideration of the normal and pathological. xxv, 104p. 4? N. Y., P. B. Hoeber, 1930. Forms v.9. Annals of Roentg., N. Y., 1930. HAY, William, 1860-1928. Obituary. Glasgow M. J., 1928, 110: 226. HAY, William Howard, 1866- Health via food. 3 p. 1. 299p. pl. 8? East Aurora, N. Y., Sun Diet Press [1929] ---- Yours for good health (with answers to 128 questions) also containing extracts from the writings of the world's foremost health authorities. 133p. 8? Pittsb., Pittsburgh Health Club, 1932. —— Weight control. 87p. portr. 16? N. Y., Hay System [1935] ---- A new health era. 212p. portr. 8? Mt Pocono, Pa., Pocono Haven [1936] ---- Building better bodies. 190p. 16? Lond., G. G. Harrap & Co. [1936] ---- Some human ailments. 281p. portr. 8? Mt Pocono, Pa., Pocono Haven [1937] See also Boyer, Josephine, & Cowdin, Katherine. Hay dieting; menus and receipts for all occasions. 2. ed. 404p. 8? N. Y., 1936. Also Smith, E. L. The official menu book of the Hay system. 421p. 20cm. Mt Pocono, Pa., 1940. ---- & SMITH, Esther L. The Hay system of child-development. 224p. 8? Lond., G. G. Harrap & Co. [1936] HAY. See also Fodder; Grass; Pasture; also Dairy industry, Dairy cow: Feeding; also names of hay plants. Carls, H. Der Phosphorsauregehalt des Wiesenheues der Grenz- und Neumark und seine Bedeutung fiir die Tierernah- rung. Arch. wiss. prakt. Tierh., 1935-36, 70: 23-42.—Fey, C. Anwendung der Heublumen nach Kneipp. Naturarztl. Rdsch., 1937, 9: 158-62— Hildebrandt, F. Beitrage zur Frage der Selbsterwarmung des Heues. Zbl. Bakt., 2. Abt., 1927, 71: 440-90.—Marcussen, P. V. Combined eczematous and urticarial hypersensitivity to hay and straw. Acta derm. vener., Stockh., 1937, 18: 186-93.—Pitchugin, V. M. [Diges- tion of hay in camels] Eksp. vet., Moskva, 1926, 4: 122-40. HAYASHI, Satao, 1898- ♦Untersuchun- gen iiber die arterielle Blutversorgung des Periodontiums. p. 145-79. 8? Berl., J. Springer, 1932. Also Deut. Mschr. Zahnh., 1932, 50: HAY BACILLUS. See Mycobacterium, phlei. HAYCK, Thaddeus. See Hagek, Thaddeus. HAYCRAFT, Howard, 1905- See Kunitz, S. J., & Haycraft, H. American authors, 1600-1900. 846p. 26cm. N. Y., 1938. HAYD, Wolfgan [Richard] 1909- ♦Car- cinommetastasen in der Milz. 23p. 8? Tiib., Becht [1935] HAYDEN 108 HAYEM HAYDEN, Austin Albert, 1881-1940. Fishbein. M. |<>bituary] Proc. Inst. M. Chicago, 1940-41, 13: 220.—Frank. I. Obituary. Ann. Otol. Rhinol., 1940, 49: 1129 C, M. A. Obituary. Laryngoscope, 1940, 50: 914.— Obituary. J. Am. M. Ass., 1940, 115: 232, portr. HAYDEN, Edwin Parker, 1894- The rectum and colon. 434p. illust. diagr. 24}£cm. Phila., Lea & Febiger, 1939. HAYDEN, Elliot A. ♦Die Prognose der Encephalitis epidemica nach den Erfahrungen in America und Europa [Basel] 21p. 8? Mulhoux'. A. Knecht, 1936. HAYDEN, Horace H., 1769-1844. Pilgrimage to the tombs of Hayden and Harris. In Proc. Dent. Centen. Celebr. (Maryland Dent. Ass.) 1940 903; 920; 956, portr.—Robinson, J. B. [Biography] Ibid., 1016. HAYDEN, James J. See Catterall, Helen Tunnicliff, & Hayden, James J. Ju- dicial cases concerning American slavery and the Negro. v.5. 386p. 8? Wash., 1937. HAYDEN, Jesse F., 1875- The art of marriage; a scientific treatise. 3. ed. 22lp. illust. 8? High Point, N. C, Book Sales Agency, 1935. HAYDEN, William R. Diseases of the brain and nervous system. 56p. 8? N. Y., New York Pharm. Co., 1880. ---- One thousand references and testi- monials from physicians, in favor of viburnum compound. 39 1. 2 pl. 12? Bedford Springs, Mass., New York Pharm. Co., 1889. ----Viburnum compounds; with the en- dorsement of 5,000 physicians. 96p. 2 pl. 12? Bedford Springs, Mass., New York Pharm. Co., 1890. Title on cover Our Southern friends 1866. HAYDN, Joseph, 1732-1809. Bokay, J. [Joseph Haydn and medicine] Orv. hetil., 1932, 76: 260-3. HAYDN, Kurt, 1912- *Die Regulation des Blutzuckergehaltes [Munchen] 56p. 21cm. Speyer, Pilger, 1938. HAYDON, Edith Mary, 1885- See Noyes, A. P., & Haydon, E. M. A textbook of psy- chiatry. 3. ed. 315p. 22cm. N. Y., 1940. HAYE, Andre Jacques Pierre, 1895- *La typhodiphterie et ses complications. 52p. 8? Par., L. Arnette, 1927. HAYE, Robert, 1907- ♦Contribution a l'etude de l'anesthSsie locale par le chlorhydrate pseudococaine droite (Delcaine) en stomatologic 40p. 8? Par., Impr. Crete, 1933. HAYEK, Heinrich von. ♦Darmdach, Chorda und Hypochorda, Bursa pharyngea und ahnliche Bildungen in der Reihe der Wirbeltiere [Rostock] p.293-344. roy. 8? Berl., J. Springer, 1931. Also Zschr. ges. Anat.. 1. Abt., 1931, 94: HAYEK, Hermann von. Immunbiologie: Dispositions- und Konstitutionsforschung; Tu- berkulose. 38p. 8? Berl., J. Springer, 1921. ---- Das Tuberkuloseproblem. 3. & 4. Aufl. x, 392p. 8? Berl., J. Springer, 1923. ---- Das Friihinfiltrat und seine praktische Bedeutung fiir die Tuberkulosebehandlung. 28p. 8? Berl., H. Kornfeld, 1929. Forms Heft 403, v. 36, Berl. Klin. HAYEK, Louis, 1903- ♦Le dromadaire; etude plus sp^ciale des maladies cutanees [Alfort] 121p. 8? Par., Jouve & cie, 1932. HAYEM, Georges, 1841-1933. Bezancon [F.] Eloge du professeur Hay em. Sang. Par., 1934,8:116-20.------ L'ceuvre de Georges Hayem. Presse med., 1933, 41: 1761-5.—Bishop, L. F. Obituary. Tr. Am. Ther. Soc, 1934, 34: 11.—Fan-eras, P. [Obituary] Rev. espan. med. cir., 1934, 17: 313-5.—Loeper, M. [Necrologie] Bull. Acad, med., Par., 1933, 3. ser., 110: 145-55.—Louvel, J. [Necrologie] Arch. mal. coeur, 1933, 26: 763.—[Necrologie] Bull. Soc. med. hop. Paris, 1934, 3. ser., 49: 1686-702. Also Prophyl. antivener., Par., 1933, 5: 372.—Rivet, L. [Necrologie] Rev. med. fr., 1933, 14: 756-60.—Siredey. A. Necrologie, J. med. chir., Par., 1933, 104: 803-7. HAYER, Erich, 1902- ♦Die staatliche Invaliden- und Hinterbliebenenversicherung in den europiiischen Kulturstaaten im Vergleich mit der deutschen Sozialversicherung. 39p. 8? Freib. i. B., Giinter & Simon, 1927. HAYES, Edmund Duncan Tranchell, 1891- See Cannon, Alexander, & Hayes, Edmund Duncan. The principles and practice of psychiatry. 437p. 8? Lond., 1932. The principles and practice of neurology. 333p. Grenfell, 8? Lond., 8! Lond., 1934 HAYES, Ernest Henry, 1881- the Labrador pioneer. 127p. Pilgrim Press, 1926. ---- Forty years on the Labrador; the life- story of Sir Wilfred Grenfell. 128p. 4 pl. 8? N. Y., F. H. Revell Co. [1930] HAYES, John Nagle, 1891- See Packard, E. N., Hayes, J. N., & Blanchet, S. F. Arti- ficial pneumothorax. 300p. 24cm. Phila., 1940. HAYES, Louis Vincent. Clinical diagnosis of diseases of the mouth; a guide for students and practitioners of dentistry and medicine, xvii, 461p. illust. pl. 8? Brooklyn, N. Y., Dent. Items Interest Pub. Co., 1935. HAYES, Maurice Richard Joseph, 1878-1930. Obituary. Brit. M. J., 1930, 1: 519. Also Irish J. M. Sc, 1930, 6. ser., 162-5, portr. Also Lancet, Lond., 1930, 1: 536. HAYES, William Pfatrick] 1887- A com- parative study of the history of certain phyto- phagous scarabaeid beetles. 146p. illust. 8? Topeka, 1925. Forms No. 16, Techn. Bull. Kansas Agr. Coll. Exp. Sta. HAYES, William Van Valzah, 1867- Chronic intestinal stasis. 15p. 12? N. Y., A. R. Elliott Co., 1914. HAY FEVER [including allergic rhinitis] See also Allergy and its subheadings; Asthma; Nose, Allergy; also the names of various allergens as Allergens; Dust; Pollen; Ragweed. Bacigaltjppi, E. E. ♦Alergia nasal; coriza o rinitis espasm6dica; sintomatologia; diagndstico; reacciones alergicas concomitantes; tratamiento; anafilaxia y alergia; conceptos modernos. 227p. 27#cm. B. Air., 1940. Coke, F. Colds and hay fever. 148p. 8? Lond., 1933. Durham, O. C. Your hay fever. 264p. 8? N. Y.[1936] Girotjd, P. ♦Le rhume des foins; etude clinique experimentale et the>apeutique. 108p. 8? Par., 1926. Lloyd, W. Hay-fever, hay asthma; its causes, diagnosis and treatment. 3. ed. 124p. 8? Lond., 1931. McCann, B. Hay fever. 88p. 8? Emaus, Pa., 1938. Bernheimer, L. B. Hyperesthetic rhinitis. Arch. Otolar., Chic, 1928, 7: 312-6.—Besche, A. de, & Kragh, J. [Allergic diseases and allergic rhinitis] Norsk, mag. laegevid., 1933, 94: 1392-403.—Black, J. H. Hay fever. Proc. Interst. Postgrad. M. Ass. N. America, 1937, 191-7.—Boeckel, L. van. Los estados alergicos en general y la fiebre de heno en particular. Rev. sudamer. endocr., B. Air., 1927, 10: 170-93.—Bray, G. W. Hay fever. Med. Press & Circ, Lond., 1939, 202: suppl., p. viii-xi.—Chandler, F. G. Hay fever. Lancet, Lond., 1926, 2: 489.—Connell, E. S. Allergic rhinitis. Month. Bull. Kansas City Clin. Soc, 1936, 12: No. 2, 9.—Conway, L. A. Hay fever. Colorado M., 1928, 25: 266-71.—Dean, L. W., Bronfenbrenner, J. J. [et al.] Allergic rhinitis. Ann. Otol. Rhinol., 1936, 45: 101-68.—Delia Vedova, T. La rinite da fieno. Gazz. osp., Milano, 1926, 47: 174-7.—Feinberg, S. M. Hyperesthetic rhinitis and hay-fever. In Cyclop. Med. (Piersol-Bortz) Phila., 1939, 7: 384-96, 2 pl.—Flach, H. Der Heuschnupfenkranke. Med. Welt, 1937, 11: 1107.—Flandin, C. Le rhume des foins. Bull, med., Par., 1928, 42: 665 — Fort, A. G. Vasomotor rhinitis. J. M. Ass. Georgia, 1930, 19: 457-9.—Fox, N., & Fabricant, N. D. Hyperesthetic rhinitis. Arch. Otolar., Chic, 1933, 18: 181-97. Also repr.—Frank, HAY FEVER 109 HAY FEVER M. N. Intumescent rhinitis and sinusitis. J. Michigan M. Soc, 1926, 25: 185-7.—Furniss, A. Hay fever. Nurs. Times, Lond., 1940, 36: 709.—Hansen, K. Heufieber. Umschau, 1928, 32: 809-13.—Hays, H. Common sense and hay fever. Am. Med., 1929, 35: 427-30.—Hercus, C. E., & D'Ath, E. F. Note on hay fever. N. Zealand M. J., 1928-29, 27: 356-67 — Holer, G. Die allergischen Erkrankungen in der Nase mit besonderer Berucksichtigung des Heuschnupfens. Wien. med. Wschr., 1931, 81: 1391-3. Also Mitt. Volksgesundhamt., Wien, 1932 [Aerztl. Prax.] 74-6. Also Wien. klin. Wschr., 1940, 53: 1047-9.—Johnston, C. R. K. Hay fever. Med. Clin. N. America, 1938, 22: 359-69.—Jurriaanse. A. Hay fever and other allergic conditions. J. M. Ass. S. Africa, 1928, 2: 388-90.—Kammerer, H. Das Heufieber. Miinch. med. Wschr., 1926, 73: 1259. Also Jahrkurs. arztl. Fortbild., 1937, 28: H. 2, 37-46.—Kehr. Das Heufieber. Umschau, 1934, 38: 381.—Kragh, J. Allergic rhinitis. Acta otolar., Stockh., 1934, 20: 282-373. ------ [Hay fever] Ugeskr. laeger, 1935, 97: 1063-6.—Lamson, R. W. Hay fever and other allergic condi- tions. Southwest M., 1936, 20: 1-4.—Leach, E. S. Hayfever; its cause, pathology and treatment. West. M. Rev., 1928, 33: 727-35. Also West. M. Times, 1928-29, 48: 75-80. Also Med. Herald, 1929, 48: 143-6.—Miller, T. P. Hay fever. Eve Ear &c. Month., 1922-23, 1: 62.—Nash, C. S. Vasomotor rhinitis. N. York State J. M., 1937, 37: 293-5.—Pressman, J. J. Vasomotor rhinitis. Laryngoscope, 1930, 40: 878-84.— Proby, H. Le coryza spasmodique. J. mid. Lyon, 1927, 8: 445-52.—Rosendahl, C. O. Causes, diagnosis and treatment of hay fever. Minnesota M., 1936, 19: 505-7.—Seal, J. C. Hyperesthetic rhinitis. Med. Rec, N. Y., 1937, 145: 114-7.— Schmiegelow, E. [Vasomotor rhinitis] Hospitalstidende, 1933, 26: [Dansk. Otolar. Selsk. Forh.] 51-63. Also Proc. R. Soc. M., Lond., 1937-38, 31: 221-6. Also J. Lar. Otol., Lond., 1938, 53: 194-201.—Spain, W. C. Hay-fever. In Cyclop. Med. (Piersol-Bortz) Phila., 1939, 7: 651-60.—Stofer, D. D. Hay fever. Month. Bull. Kansas City Clin. Soc, 1929, 5: 21-3.—Thommen, A. A. Hay fever; fact, fancy and fallacv; studies in hay fever. Med. J. & Rec, 1932, 136: 94-7. Also repr.-—Trasoff, A. Vasomotor rhinitis. Laryngoscope, 1933, 43: 531-9.—Viganoni, G. Sulla febbre da fieno. Arch. ital. otol., 1933, 45: 778-806, 6 ch.—Watson-Williams, E. Spas- modic rhinorrhoea. Bristol Med. Chir. J., 1939, 56: 109-26 — Weiss. L. Hay fever. Eye Ear &c. Month., 1933, 12: 110. ---- Allergen. See also subheading Etiology; also Allergens; also names of allergens as Dust; Flour; Pollen; Ragweed, &c; also names of occupations as Baker, &c. Adlersberg, D., & Forschner, L. Rhinopathia vasomotoria und Verdauungsstorungen. Wien. klin. Wschr., 1928, 41: 955-8. Also Zschr. Hals &c. Heilk., 1928, 20: 250-3 [Dis- cussion] 291-301.—Baag0e, K. H. [Allergic, vasomotor rhinitis (flour sneeze) in bakers] Ugeskr. laeger, 1935, 97: 897-900.— Beecher, W. L. Hyperesthetic rhinitis and asthma due to digestive ferments. Illinois M. J., 1931, 59: 343.—Benjamins, C. E. [Observations on substances causing hay fever] Ned. mschr. geneesk., 1930-31, 17: 703-12, ch., diag.—Berkoff, H. S. Non-pollen inhalants in hay fever; a study of their part in its symptomatology. N. York State J. M., 1937, 37: 1499- 1502.—Brown, G. T. Perennial hay-fever due to parrot feathers. J. Am. M. Ass., 1929, 92: 465.—Cohen, M. B., & Rudolph, J. A. Hay-fever; the importance of substances other than pollen in the etiology; their influence on seasonal cure. Arch. Int. M., 1930, 45: 742-8.—Engelsher, D. L. Hay fever and asthma due to dog hair. Med. Rec, N. Y., 1934, 139: 573 — ErtI, E. Rhinitis vasomotoria; Heilung nach Entfernung eines Wurzelgranuloms. Mschr. Ohrenh., 1936, 70: 484.—Eyer- mann, C. H. Food allergy as a cause of vasomotor rhinitis. South. M. J., 1938, 31: 210-5.—Galjart, J. S. Coryza nervosa; report of 2 cases of hypersensitiveness to feathers. Acta oto- lar., Stockh., 1926, 9: 525-34.—Greeley, H. P. Multiple sensitiveness in hay fever and asthma. Wisconsin M. J., 1932, 31: 242-5.—Kecskes, Z. [Nervous rhinitis in industrial work- ers] Orv. hetil., 1938, 82: 343.—McGibbon, J. E. G. Spas- modic rhinorrhoea probably due to fur dye (para-phenylene- diamine) J. Lar. Otol., Lond., 1933, 48: 702.—Piness, G., & Miller, H. The importance of food sensitization in allergic rhinitis. J. Allergy, 1930-31, 2: 73-5.—Roux, D. J. [Vaso- motor rhinitis among flour-mill workers] Ned. tschr. geneesk., 1939, 83: 3066-8.—Rowe, A. H. House dust in the etiology of bronchial asthma and of hay-fever. Arch. Int. M., 1927, 39: 498-507.—Storm van Leeuwen, W., Krause, K., & Tissot van Patot, P. N. Ueber die Ueberempfindlichkeit gegen Hausstaub. Zschr. Immunforsch., 1929, 62: 390-404.—Sweetser, H. B. Multiple sensitivity in hay fever. Minnesota M., 1936, 19: 510.—Urbach, E. Nahrungsmittelidiosynkrasien als gelegent- liche Ursache von Rhinitis vasomotoria und Asthma. Mschr. Ohrenh., 1932, 66: 160-5.—Watson-Williams. E. Occupa- tional spasmodic rhinorrhoea. Lancet, Lond., 1931, 2: 1237. ---- Allergen: Pollen [and spore] See also under names of fungi and plants as Ambrosia; Ragweed, &c. Reference table of hay fever pollens; par- tial list, showing distribution and relative im- portance in hay fever. 1 sheet. Phila., 1924. Balyeat, R. M. The importance of orris root as an etiologic factor in hay fever and asthma; based on the study of 1,000 cases of hay fever and asthma. J. Lab. Clin. M., 1927-28, 13: 516-22.—Bauer, W. W. Hay fever and weeds. Hygeia, Chic, 1937, 15: No. 8, 678.—Benjamins, C. E. [Second and late grass bloom in hay fever] Ned. tschr. geneesk., 1936, 80: 4242.—Bernton, H. S. Hay fever and asthma caused by the pollen of the Paper Mulberry (Papyrius papyrifera Kuntze) J. Lab. Clin. M., 1927-28, 13: 829-36. ------ & Thorn, C. The importance of molds as allergic excitants in some cases of vasomotor rhinitis. J. Allergy, 1933, 4: 114-21.—Black, J. H. Cedar hay fever. Ibid., 1929-30, 1: 71-3.—Blumstein, G., & Tuft, L. Plantain hay fever; its incidence and importance. Tr. Coll. Physicians Philadelphia, 1936-37, 4: 94. Also J. Am. M. Ass., 1937, 108: 1500-2.—Bouzat, L. G., & Villar, A. D. Puccinia triticina Erikss. como factor al6rgioo. Prensa med. argent., 1941, 28: 658-61.—Bozzola, J. A., Bacigaluppi, E. E., & Parodi, L. R. Patergia al pldtano. Sem. med., B. Air., 1940, 47: pt 2, 1215-8.—Bullen, S. S. Perennial hay fever from Indian gum (Karaya gum) J. Allergy, 1934, 5: 484-7.—Carron, R. F., & Malvarez, H. E. Polinosis por tala; reacciones sistemicas y constitucionales. Prensa mid. argent., 1941, 28: 1114-6.—Derbes, V. J. The linden, Tilia, as a factor in seasonal pollinosis. J. Allergy, 1940-41, 12: 502-6.— Durham, O. C. Pollen and hay fever. Science, 1938, 87:167.— Dutton, L. O. Beet pollen and beet seed dust causing hay fever and asthma. J. Allergy, 1937-38, 9: 607-9.—Fond6, G. H., & Fonde, E. C. Honey dew from the live oak a cause of hay fever and asthma. Ibid., 1934-35, 6: 288-90.—Hein- berg, C. J. Spiny amaranth. J. Florida M. Ass., 1930-31, 17: 221-4.—Kahn, I. S. Some experiences with careless-weed (amaranth) pollen extracts. Texas J. M., 1926-27, 22: 465. ------ Mountain cedar hay fever. Med. J. & Rec, 1932, 136: 54.—King, J. H. Hav fever due to Alternaria spores in the Cincinnati area. J. Med., Cincin., 1939-40, 20: 34.— Langley, W. D. Sensitivity to piqueria pollen with case report. J. Allergy, 1937-38, 9: 60.—Moore, M. W. General considera- tion of vaso-motor rhinitis with a reported case of flaxseed sensitivity. Northwest M., 1934, 33: 95-9.—Phillips, E. W. Orris coryza. Southwest. M., 1927, 11: 299-303. ------ Time required for the production of hay fever by spores of a newly encountered fungus, Johnson grass smut. J. Allergy, 1940-41, 12: 24-7.—Pratt, H. N., & Roorbach, C. L. Species specificity of Alternaria in asthma and hay fever. Ibid., 431- 7.—Rowe, A. H. Pine pollen allergy. Ibid., 1938-39, 10: 377.—Sellers, E. D., & Adamson, W. B. A study of the apparent atopic similarity of certain Chenopodiales pollens. Ibid., 1932, 3: 166-71.—Stull, A., Cooke, R. A., & Barnard, J. H. The biologic identity of certain grass pollens causing hay fever. Ibid., 352-6.—Swineford, O., jr. Catalpa as a cause of hay fever; a case report and results of 84 skin tests. Ibid., 1939-40, 11: 398-401.—Thone, F. Don't blame the goldenrod; most likely it is the unsightly, but innocent appear- ing ragweed that causes the so-called hayfever. Science News Lett., 1937, 32: 9C-2.—Vaughan, W. T., & Crockett, R. W. An assay of goldenrod as a cause of hay fever. Ann. Int. M., 1932, 6: 789-94.—Waring, J. J., & Pope, M. The cotton of the Cottonwood tree a factor in hay fever; a prelim- inary report. Colorado M., 1927, 24: 218-22. ---- Allergen: Pollen: Examination. See also subheading Treatment: Desensitiza- tion. Benjamins, C. E. Recherches sur la substance active du pollen des graminees. Acta otolar., Stockh., 1936, 24: 153-61. Also Ned. tschr. geneesk., 1936, 80: 2064. ■------Dishoeck, H. A. E. v., & German, J. L. M. Studies on the active sub- stance of grass pollen; activation of a small molecular weight active group through colloidal substances. J. Allergy, 1934-35, 6: 335-48.—Benjamins, C. E., Idzerda, J., & Nienhuis, J. H. [New researches on the specificity of the effective substances in pollens] Ned. tschr. geneesk., 1929, 73: 143-50.—Berger, F. Das Verhalten der heufieber-erregenden Pollen im filtrierten ultravioletten Licht; zur Lumineszenzanalvse der Pollen. Beitr. Biol. Pflanz., 1934, 22: 1-12.—Garvin, P. D., & Kurland, S. K. Heterophile antigen content of pollen: a negative report. J. Allergy, 1935-36, 7: 475.—Moore. G. T., & La Garde, R. V. L. The identification of pollen from so-called hay-fever plants. Ann. Missouri Bot. Gard., 1926, 13: 355-90.—Osgood, H.. & Hubbard, R. S. The skin exciting activity of a timothy pollen extract as measured by its content of 3 nitrogen frac- tions. J. Allergy, 1934-35, 6: 349-56.—Thomsen, O., & Baape'e, K. [Experimental researches on the antigenic effect of various kinds of pollen] Ugeskr. lapger, 1927, 89: 1171-5.— Wilmer, H. B., & Cobe, H. M. The efficacy of hothouse grown pollen as compared with field grown pollen. J. Allergy, 1932, 3: 442-8. ---- Bibliography. Feinberg, S. M. Progress in hay fever; a review of the hay fever literature of the years 1927 and 1928. J. Lab. CUn. M., 1928-29, 14: 726-46. ------ Review of the hay fever litera- ture of 1929. J. Allergy, 1929-30, 1: 313-23. ------ & HAY FEVER 110 HAY FEVER Bernstein, T. B. Asthma and hay fever; review of literature for 1938. Ibid., 1938-39, 10: 283-307. ■------ Asthma and hay fever; contributions during 1939. Ibid., 1939-40, 11: 281-308. ---- Cases. Balyeat, R. M. Secondary factors in uncomplicated cases of seasonal hay fever: based on a study of 719 cases. J. Lab. Clin. M., 1928-29, 14: 617-20.—Bergstrom, E. [Case of vasomotor rhinitis] Nonl. med., 1939, 4: 3379-84.—Bourgeois, H. A propos d'un cas an el desequilibrio humoral y Air lQ?7P-.iC° +69 la* »™tlsDespasm6dica8- Sem. med., B Air., 1927, 34: pt 2, 551-64.—Rinkel, H. J.. & Balyeat R M Ass°ni9a3T w^In X? SfaST,al hay fever- J- Oklahoma m! ass., 1931, 24: 240-5, pl Also repr.—Sachsse. H. Ueber die 9. 233-6.-Th0mmen. A. A. The etiology of hay fever HAY FEVER 111 HAY FEVER studies in hay fever. N. York State J. M., 1930, 30: 437-42.— Wilson, G. W. A study of structural and instinctual conflicts in cases of hay fever. Psychosomat. M., 1941, 3: 51-65.— Wittkower, E. Studies in hay-fever patients; the allergic personality. J. Ment. Sc, Lond., 1938, 84: 352-69. ---- Hematology. Bacigaluppi, E. E. Importancia del fndice leucop6nico de Vaughan en las rinitis espasm6dicas. Sem. mid., B. Air., 1938, 45: pt 2, 1496-501.—Bullen. S. S., & Bloor, W. R. Lipids of the blood plasma in hay fever and asthma. J. Allergv, 1936-37, 8: 155-7.—Gelfand, H. H., & Victor, G. The sedi- mentation rate in hay fever; before and during the seasonal exacerbation. Ibid., 1934, 5: 583-9.—Harley, D. A phago- cytic reaction in hay fever. Brit. M. J., 1933, 1: 138.—Stern- berg, L. Eosinophilia in hay fever. Am. J. M. Sc, 1928, 176: 82-7.—Zeller, M. The leucopenic index in vasomotor rhinitis. J. Lab. Clin. M., 1935-36, 21: 1274-8. ---- History. Barker, C. Daniel Webster and the hav-fever. Yale J. Biol., 1936-37, 9: 393-402.—Hurwitz, S. H. Hav fever; a sketch of its early history. J. Allergy, 1929-30, 1: 245-59.— Leech, E. B. Nova et Vetera; Charles Harrison Blackley (1820-1900) of Manchester, and hay fever. Brit. M. J., 1929. 2: 1171, portr. ---- Immunology, and serology. Ducret, S. ^Experimentelle Untersuchungen iiber den Prausnitz-Kustner'schen Antikorper beim Heufieber [Zurich] 13p. 8? Zug, 1927. Albus, G. Serologische Allergenbestimmung bei Pollen- krankheit unter Berucksichtigung des Antikorpertiters. Zschr. ges. exp. Med., 1935, 96: 710-4.—Black, J. H., & Kemp, H. A. Blood density in guinea pig anaphylaxis and in hay fever artificially induced. Am. J. Clin. Path., 1937, 7: 300-6.— Caulfeild, A. H. W.. Brown, M. H. & Waters, E. T. Alum as an adjuvant in sensitizing guinea pigs to ragweed pollen (Ambrosia artemisnfolia) J. Allergy, 1935-36, 7: 451-4.— Cohen, M. B. & Nelson, T. A sheep antibody which blocks the Prausnitz-Kiistner reaction. J. Immun., Bait., 1938, 34: 63-9.—Cooke, R. A., Barnard, J. H. [et al.] Serological evi- dence of immunity with coexisting sensitization in a tvpe of human allergy (hay fever) J. Exp. M., 1935, 62: 733-50, pl. Also repr.—Cooke, R. A., Loveless, M., & Stull, A. Studies on immunity in a type of human allergy (hay-fever) serologic response of non-sensitive individuals to pollen injections. Ibid., 1937, 66: 689-96. Also repr.—Dr Karl Landsteiner— antibodies and sneezes. Science News Lett., 1936, 30: 187.— Fairen. V. Etude physico-chimique du serum dans les rhinites colloidoclasiques. Acta otolar., Stockh., 1930, 14: 282-5.— Farmer, L. On the immunologic relationship between grass pollen and seed. J. Allergy, 1936-37, 8: 338.—Grubb, G. D. & Vaughan, W. T. Evidence of group specific and species specific sensitization to pollen. Ibid., 1937-38, 9: 211-26.—Harley D. Hay fever; a study of reagin-allergen mixtures. Brit. J. Exp. Path., 1933, 14: 171-9. ■------ Hay fever: its immunological mechanism, diagnosis, and treatment. Brit. M. J., 1935, 1: 754-6.—Hensel, M. E., & Sheldon, J. M. Complement fixation with specific allergens in hav fever. J. Lab. Clin. M., 1940-41, 26: 1586-93.—Langner, P. H., jr, & Kern. R. A. Studies on the immunology of hay fever; confirmation of blocking substance formation by pollen treatment; use of lyophile serum in study and treatment. J. Allergy, 1938-39, 10: 1-14.—Lichtenstein, M. R. Attempt to produce the atopic inhibitor antibody in nonatopic individuals. Ibid., 1936-37, 8: 228.—Loveless, M. H. Immunological studies of pollinosis; the presence of two antibodies related to the same pollen-antigen in the serum of treated hay-fever patients. J. Immun., Bait., 1940, 38: 25-50. -—;---Immunological studies of pollinosis; passive sensitization of man through transfusion. Ibid., 1941, 41: 15-34.—Rackemann, F. M., & Wagner H. C. The desensitization of skin sites passively sensitized with serum of patients with hay fever; crossed reactions of different pollens; the variations in the recipient. J. Allergy, 1935-36, 7: 319-32.—Ramsdell, S. G. A study of pollen immune serum. J. Immun., Bait., 1926, 12: 231-6. ------ A note on the complement-fixation reaction in anti- pollen serum. J. Lab. Clin. M., 1926-27, 12: 259-64 — Schmidt, W. M, & Lippard, V. W. Human passive transfer antibody; serial titrations on treated and untreated patients with hay fever. Am. J. Dis. Child., 1938, 56: 550r60 — Stevens F. M. Chemical study of the pollen-sensitizing anti- body combination, J. Immun., Bait., 1935, 29: 273-8 — Stull, A., Sherman W. B., & Cooke, R. A. The association with pseudoglobulin of the skin sensitizing substance of allergic (hay fever) serum. J. Allergy, 1937-38, 9: 7-13.—Wagner, H. C, & Rackemann, F. M. Studies in hay fever: specific desensitization of skin sites in actively sensitive persons. Ibid., 1935-36, 7: 543-51. ---- Manifestation. ' Baldwin, L. B. Some observations on the skin and mucous membrane reactions in hay fever. J. Immun., Bait., 1927, 13: 345-56.—Benjamins, C. E. & Graaf, J. de. L'utiUte des symptomes nasaux dans le rhume des foins. Acta otolar., Stockh., 1934, 20: 165-80.—Bernheimer, L. B. Color index of the nasal septum; a critical study of the vasomotor mechan- ism of the nose. Arch. Otolar., Chic, 1934, 20: 31-7 — Bilchick, E. B. Color of the nasal septum; its relation to auto- nomic imbalance. Ibid., 1936, 24: 768-70.—Bruins, J. J. [Symptoms in coryza nervosa pointing to anaphylaxis] Ned. tschr. geneesk., 1923, 67: pt 2, 288-90.—Eyermann, C. H. Nasal manifestations of allergy. Ann. Otol. Rhinol., 1927, 36: 808-15.—Fontana, D. Disfonia con singolare reperto laringo- scopico m caso di corizza nervosa. Ann. laring., Tor., 1938, 38: 19-22.—Huber, H. L. A critical analysis of the informa- tion obtained from hay-fever sufferers. J. Allergy, 1930-31, 2: 48-53.—Jarvis, D. C. The red septum. Laryngoscope, 1933, 43: 42-7.—Lermoyez, J. Les phtaomenes de choc dans le coryza spasmodique. Ann. mal. oreille, 1924,43:309-80.— Scheppegrell, W. Distribution and reactions of hay fever. Med. J. & Rec, 1926, 124: 323-6. Also repr.—Thommen, A. A. Hay fever; its symptomatology; studies in hay fever. N. York State J. M., 1930, 30: 835-9. ---- Pathogenesis. Rebillard, P. *Le sympathique dans ses rapports avec le coryza spasmodique. 80p. 8? Par., 1925. Bergara, R., & Bergara, C. Patogenia de la rinitis espas- modica y de la hidrorrea nasal; tratamiento. Rev. As. med. argent., 1932, 45: 337-67, 2 pl.—Bernton, H. S., Jones, D. B., & Csonka, F. A. Pollen proteins and their cUnical significance in hay fever; a preliminary communication. South. M. J., 1927, 20: 257-69.—Clarke, J. A., jr, & Leopold, H. C. Effect of pollen contact upon the age of onset of hay fever. J. Allergy, 1939-40, 11: 494-7.—Dittmar, F. Das Heufieber; Pathogenese, Klinik und Therapie der Pollenallergie. Zschr. arztl. Fortbild., 1939, 36: 266-70—Feinberg, S. M. Seasonal hay fever not due to pollen. Ann. Int. M., 1929-30, 3: 1035-7. ------ Nasal allergy as related to hay fever and hyperesthetic rhinitis. Ann. Otol. Rhinol.; 1930, 39: 720-32.—Flandin, C. Discussion sur le rhume des foins. Bull, mid., Par., 1928, 42: 765.— Forman, J. Contact allergic coryza. Arch. Otolar,, Chic, 1934, 19: 367-9, pl.—Glasscheib, A. Zur Frage der Rhinitis vasomotoria. Mschr. Ohrenh., 1930, 64: 316.—Grain, R. Le rhume des foins; essai pathogenique. Bull. Soc. mid. Paris, 1938, 322-7.—Griebel, C. R. Rhinitis vasomotoria als aller- gische Erkrankung (Rhinopathia allergica) Klin. Wschr., 1938, 17: 164-71.—Halphen. E., & Maduro, R. Essai d'in- terpreLation du mecanisme de la crise de coryza spasmodique. Bull, med., Par., 1940, 54: 257-9.—Hofer, G. Die allergischen Erkrankungen in der Nase mit besonderer Berucksichtigung des Heuschnupfens. Wien. klin. Wschr., 1931, 44: 1003-5.—■ Joltrain, E. Considerations sur la maladie du pollen (rhume et asthme des foins) eLiologie, Evolution, traitement. J. mid. Paris, 1934, 54: 748-51. ------ Rhume des foins, anaphy- laxie et histamine. Bull. Soc. mid. Paris, 1938, 328-35. Also J. mid. Paris, 1938, 58: 616-8.—Just, T. Allergic factors in rhinorrhoea and nasal catarrh. Brit. M. J., 1934, 2: 587-9.— Kaupe, W. Heuschnupfen und exsudative Diathese. Med. Klin., BerL, 1929, 25: 1173.—Kuttner, A. Rhinitis nervosa, eine Neurose der Nase in Parallele zu den Neurosen des Ver- dauungstractus. Arch. Verdauungskr., 1926, 37: 128-32.— Lakos, T. Z. Vasomotor rhinitis as a bacterio-allergic disease (with a discussion of its etiology and therapy) Acta otolar., Stockh., 1932, 17: 400-7.—Lugli, G. Sulla patogenesi della rinite vasomotoria. Arch. ital. laring., 1932-33, 52: 154-63. Riniti vasomotorie e anafilassi. Boll. mal. orecchio, 1933, 51: 195-201. Also Arch. ital. laring., 1934, 53: 23-9.- Phillips, E. W. Time required for the production of hay fever by a newly encountered pollen, sugar beet. J. Allergy, 1939-40, 11: 28-31.—Popov, F. A. [Vegetative reactivity of the ear, nose and larynx] Vest, otorinolar., 1937, 395-9.-—Riccitelli, E., & Franchini, Y. Factores que favorecen, que predisponen y que determinan el desequilibrio humoral y vago simpsStico en las rinitis espasm6dicas. Rev. espec, B. Air., 1927, 2: 521-60.—Riegele, L. Die Beziehungen der autonome Nervenfasern der Nasenschleimhaut zu den Reticuloendo- thelien und ihre Bedeutung fiir anaphylaktisch-allergische Prozesse. Zschr. Hals &c Heilk., 1933-34, 35: 554-9.— Rudolph, J. A., & Cohen, M. B. Vasomotor rhinitis with negative skin tests: a local nasal allergy. J. Allergy, 1934, 5: 476-83.—Spitz, H. Pollen sensitization. J. Tennessee M. Ass., 1927-28, 20: 78-81.—Sterling, A., & Fishman, A. E. Transmission of ragweed pollen antigen through the breast milk. Arch. Pediat., N. Y., 1938, 55: 172-7.—Tuft, L. Allergy in relation to vasomotor rhinitis. Pennsylvania M. J., 1932, 36: 30-5.—Urbach, E. Pathogenese und Therapie des Heu- Gebers (Rhinopathia pollinosa; Asthma pollinosum) Med. KUn., BerL, 1934, 30: 253; 290. Also Wien. klin. Wschr., 1934, 47: 1073.—Vaughan, W. T. PolUnosis: constitutional and local factors. Arch. Int. M., 1927, 40: 386-96. Also repr.— Wolfe, J. T. Theory of hay-fever: with case reports. Am. Med., 1935, 41:312-14. ---- Pathology. Toussaint, G. *Rhinites spasmodiques p6ri- odiques et aperiodiques. 62p. 8? Par., 1911. 12 HAY FEVER HAY FEVER Carmody, T. K., & Greene, L. W. The relation of sinus disease to hav fev<»r. Tr. Am. Acad. Ophth. Otolar., 1928, 33: 445-9. Also \uu. Otol. Rhinol., 1929, 38: 759-62, 3 pl — Daudin-Clavaud, IL Les plaques et papules cedemateuses de la pituitaire dans les affections spasmodiques d'origine ou k manifestations nasales. Rev. laryng., Par., 1929, 50: 151- 63 Hathaway. M. L., Rappaport, B. Z. [et al.] A study of blond ennMituents in pollinosis with and without treatment. J. All. isrv. 1936-37, 8: 1-21.—Hyman, M. Hay fever: rhino- logical aspects. Eclect. M. J., 1933, 93: 215-9.—Kehr. Eigen- tumlichkeiten der allergischen Krankheiten, insbesondere des Heufiebers. Ther. Gegenwart, 1935, 76: 205-9.—Kern, R. A., & Donnelly, J. C. The incidence and role of paranasal sinus disease in hay fever. J. Allergy, 1932, 3: 172-9.— l.cirher. Ueber allergische Rhinitis (ausschliesshch des lhaiMhnupfens) Zschr. Hals &c. Heilk., 1928, 20: 238-50 [Discussion] 291-301.—Montgomery, R. R. The physiology of allergic and non-allergic rhinitis. Tr. Am. Lar. Rhin. Otol. Soc, 1940, 46: 484-90.—Podesta, R. La inflamaci6n hiper£rgica en las rinitis y sinusitis alfrgicas. Rev. As. mid. argent., 1935, 49: 1540-6.—Rugani, R. Ricerche istopato- logiche nella rhinitis spasmodica. Osp. maggiore, Milano, 1929, 17: 284-92.—Ruskin, S. L. A trophic and vasomotor rhinitis; the physiology of the nasal mucosa. Arch. Otolar., Chic, 1930, 11: 689-95. Also repr.—Sternberg, H. Ueber Nebenhohlenbefunde bei Rhinitis vasomotoria. Mschr. Ohrenh., 1928, 62: 1074-9.—Lrbach, E. Vasomotor rhinitis; a proposed classification based on an analysis of 74 cases. Arch. Otolar., Chic, 1941, 33: 982-92. ---- perennial. Balyeat, R. M. Perennial hay fever; diagnosis and treat- ment, based on the study of 441 cases. South. M. J., 1929, 22: 492-502.—Brown, G. T. Perennial hay-fever. Tr. Am. Lar. Rhin. Otol. Soc, 1931, 37: 272-88. Also repr. Also Arch. Otolar., Chic, 1932, 15: 202-17. Also repr.—Rabe, R. F. The perennial hay-fever question. J. Am. Inst. Homeop., 1937, 30: 679.—Rinkel, H. J. Perennial vasomotor rhinitis. J. Iowa M. Soc, 1937, 27: 93-8.—Winkenwerder, W. L., & Gay. b. N. Perennial allergic rhinitis: an analysis of 198 cases. Bull. Johns Hopkins Hosp., 1937, 61: 90-100. ---- Prevention. Ambler, A. B. Hay fever and its preventive treatment. 16p. 8? [Ambler, Pa., 190-(?)] Dayton, Ohio. Frigidaire Corporation. Relief from hay-fever and other disorders by means of Frigidaire air conditioning. 32p. 8? Dayton, O. [1933] Beck, I. The treatment of hay fever and pollen asthma with pollen free air. Med. J. & Rec, 1932, 136: 90-4.—Clarke, J. A., jr. Personal avoidance of pollen, an aid to the treatment of hay fever. Week. Roster, Phila., 1941-42, 37: 7. ------& Leopold, H. C. Prophylactic treatment for ragweed hav fever; a statistical study. J. Allergy, 1936-37, 8: 560-5.—Cohen, M. B. A poUen filter; preUminary report of the treatment of hay fever in rooms made pollen free by a new filter. Med. J. & Rec, 1926, 123: 322. ------ The prophylaxis and treat- ment of hay-fever and asthma by means of pollen filters. Clin. Med., 1927, 34: 276-8. ------ The prophylaxis and treat- ment of hay fever and asthma in rooms made pollen and dust free by means of mechanical filters. J. Lab. CUn. M., 1927-28, 13: 59-63.—Dautwiz, R. Seereisen fiir Heufieberkranke. Med. Welt, 1937, 11: 589—Davies, C. Air filtration in hay fever reUef. Med. Rec, N. Y., 1934, 139: 543.—Gay, L. N. The treatment of hay fever and pollen asthma by air-condi- tioned atmosphere. J. Am. M. Ass., 1933, 100: 1382-5. Also repr.—Gould, A. G. Cumulative immunity from hay fever preventive inoculations. Boston M. & S. J., 1926, 194: 932-4 — Hayfever again—prevention pays. Week. Health BuU. Connecticut, 1935, 17: No. 35, L—Hiltner, E. Die Phiinologie und ihre Bedeutung fiir die kUmatische Behandlung der Pollenallergie. Aerztl. Rdsch., 1929, 39: 133; 148.—Jack, G. N. A prophylactic gas filtering ventilator for summer autumnal coryza and asthma. Med. J. & Rec, 1924, 120: 164-8.—Kendall, T. A., & Weidner, G. Observations of hay- fever sufferers in air-conditioned room and the relationship between the pollen content of outdoor air and weather condi- tions. Tr. Am. Soc Heat. Ventil. Engin., 1934, 40: 229-52 — Metzger, F. C. The cUmatic treatment of hay fever and asthma with special reference to Florida. J. Am. M. Ass., 1939, 112: 29-32.—Nelson, T. Is hay fever a pubUc health problem? niinois M. J., 1934, 65: 44-8. ------ Rappaport, B. Z.. & Welker, W. H. The effect of air filtration in hay fever and poUen asthma. J. Am. M. Ass., 1933, 100: 1385-92. Also repr.—Peshkin, M. M., & Beck, I. A new and simplified mechanical air filter in the treatment of hay fever and pollen asthma. J. Lab. Clin. M., 1928-30, 15: 643-9.—Rappaport, B. Z., Nelson, T., & Welker, W. H. Effect of air filtration in hay fever and poUen asthma. J. Am. M. Ass., 1932, 98: 1861-4. Also repr.—Rawlings, J. A. El Paso's history of weed eradication relative to hay fever. Southwest. M., 1931, 15: 265.—Vander Veer, A. Hay fever as a public health problem. Hosp. Social Serv., 1933, 27: 302-7.—Vaughan, W. T. The control of poUen auergy. J. Lab. CUn. M., 1932-33, 18: 240-54. ------ The possibility of hay fever prevention through pubUc health measures. Health News, Albany, 1936, 13: 125-7.—Voss. O., & Griebel, K. Kunst- liches Hochgebirgszimmer (aUergenfreics, mit kunsthcher Hohensonne und Ultrarotlampen versehenes Zimmer, dessen Luftdruck beliebig variiert werden kann) Zschr. Hals &o. Heilk., 1928, 20: 270-4 [Discussion] 291-301.—Wovschin, W. A. The basic ideology for a new method of hay fever prophylaxis and its aUied aUergies; preliminary report. Med J. &Rec, 1930, 131:296-9. ---- Prognosis. Freeman, J. Prognosis in hay-fever. Lancet, Lond., 1936, 2: 92.—Rackemann, F. M. The ultimate prognosis in hay fever. Am. J. M. Sc, 1929, 177: 333-8.—Walker, I. C. Cura- biUty of hav fever after preseasonal pollen treatment. Arch. Int. M., 1934, 54: 289-307. ------ The curability of pollen hay fever. Med. Clin. N. America, 1935-36, 19: 1547-62. ---- Relation to asthma. Balyeat, R. M. Hay-fever and asthma; a practical handbook for hay-fever and asthma patients. 198p. 8? Phila., 1926. Also 2. ed. 310p. 1928. Coca, A., Walzer, M., & Thommen, A. A. Asthma and hay fever in theory and practice. 851p. 8? Springf., 111., 1931. Cohen, M. B. Hay fever, asthma, and other allergic dis- eases. Kentuckv M. J., 1931, 29: 319-25. Also Med. Insur., 1931, 47: 139-48.—Crowell, T. C. Hay fever and asthma—its causes and control. J. Tennessee M. Ass., 1933, 26: 204-8 — Garrett, J. D. Seasonal hay fever and bronchial asthma. Tr. Indiana Acad. Ophth. Otolar., 1928, 12: 63-83. Also J. Indiana M. Ass., 1929, 22: 94-100.—Haibe, A. Les equiva- lents de l'asthme; le coryza spasmodique ou rhume des foins. Bruxelles med., 1933-34, 14: 749.—Harley, D. Allergische Krankheiten auf dem Gebiete der inneren Medizin, Heufieber und Asthma. In Fortschr. Allerg. (Kall6s, P.) Basel, 1939, 170-200.—Hay fever and asthma. BuU. san., Montreal, 1940, 40: 52-4. Also Pub. Health Rep., Wash., 1940, 55: 1742-4.—Henson, G. E. Hay fever and bronchial asthma; with report of cases. Eye Ear &c Month., 1939-40, 18: 78-80.—Kolmer, J. A. The nature of hay fever and bronchial asthma. Tr. Am. Lar. Rhin. Otol. Soc, 1926, 32: 373-82. Also Ann. Otol. Rhinol., 1926-27, 35: 757-68.—Pasteur Vallery-Radot, Blamoutier, P., & Justin-Besancon. Le coryza spasmodique Equivalent de 1'asthme (d'apres 188 observations) Presse med., 1928, 36: 625-8.—Rice, G. B. Hyperesthetic rhinitis and asthma. CUn. M. S., 1930, 37: 415-9. --- Research. Colorado. State Historical and Natural History Society. Hay Fever Research Committee. Report. 75p. 8? Denver, 1926. Berkoff, H. S. A group study in hay fever. N. York State J. M., 1933, 33: 743-7.—Dean. L. W. Panel discussion of allergic rhinitis. Tr. Am. Laryng. Ass., 1936, 42: 404-7.— Feinberg, S. M., & Steinberg, M. J. Studies in pollen potency; the effect of pollen injections on the common cold in hay fever subjects. J. AUergy, 1934-35, 6: 19; 304.—Karpiloff, G. Sur l'influence de la poussiSre sur la muqueuse nasale chez le lapin. Ann. otolar., Par., 1934, 584-92.—Kehr. Der neueste Stand der Heufieberforschung. Med. Welt, 1933, 7: 632.— Urbach, E., & Wiethe, C. ExperimenteUe Untersuchungen bei einem nasal gegen verschiedene Mehlarten uberempfindlichen Backer. Munch, med. Wschr., 1931, 78: 1470-3.—Wilmer, H. B., Cooke, R. A. [et al.] Round table discussion on problems in hay fever. J. Allergy, 1939-40, 11: 509-26. ---- seasonal. Bozzola, J. A. *Alergia polinica. 237p. 26^cm. B. Air., 1940. Balyeat, R. M. Seasonal hay-fever; a study of 300 con- secutive cases. J. Oklahoma M. Ass., 1928, 21: 106-14. Also repr.—Belbeze, R. Le rhume des foins; maladie du pollen. J. sc. med. LiUe, 1913, 36: 626; pt 2, 13; 35.—Bernton, H. S. Pollenosis. Wisconsin M. J., 1927, 26: 242-7.—Bozzola, J. A. Polinosis (fiebre del heno) Sem. med., B. Air., 1935, 42: 845-7.—Brown, A. Diagnosis and treatment of seasonal hay fever. Med. J. & Rec, 1926, 123: 301-3.—Bubert, H. M. Atypical pollen hay-fever. BuU. School M. Univ. Maryland, 1931, 15: 173-7.—Clock, R. O. Spring hay fever, its causes and preventive treatment. Med. J. & Rec, 1926, 123: 641-4 — Ellis, R. V. PolUnosis; from the standpoint of preventive medicine and public health. J. Lancet, 1940, 60: 253-8.— Feinberg, S. M., & Durham, O. C. Atypical hay fever seasons; their significance in treatment. Ann. Int. M., 1934-35, 8: 1282-6.—Gutmann, M. J. Rund um die PollenaUergie (Heu- schnupfen, Heufieber, Heuasthma) Munch, med. Wschr., 1933, 80: 258-62—Klewite, F. Fortschritte in der Diagnostik und Therapie der PoUenallergie (Heuschnupfen) KUn. FortbUd., 1935, 3: 490-3—Knott, F. A., Gill-Carey. C, & HAY FEVER 113 HAY FEVER Hurst. A. F. Seasonal hay fever. Practitioner, Lond., 1932, 129: 45-56.—Nasso, I. Le pneumallergie, Athena, Roma, 1938, 7: 279.—Quay, G. H. Rinitis peri6dica hiperestesica. Rev. homeop., Barcel., 1901, 12: Suppl., 123-32.—Ruiz Moreno, G. Polinosis. Dia med., B. Air., 1940, 12: 113-8 — Sakai, Y. Ueber die Pollenanaphylaxie. Okayama igakkai zasshi, 1934, 46: 1891.—Scimone, V. Le pollinosi. Clin. med. ital., 1931, 62: 280-305—Taub-, S. J., & Friedman, T. B. Pollinosis. Med. CUn. N. America, 1937-38, 21: 129-37.— Thommen, A. A. Hay fever; the spring type; studies in hay fever. Med. J. & Rec, N. Y., 1930, 131: 496-501. Also repr. Also N. York State J. M., 1930, 30: 577-83.—Thone. F. Hay fever time; since most hay fever is due to 2 ragweeds, their blooming- is a signal for sneezes. Science News Lett., 1939, 36: 90-2.—Vuletig. V. I. The pollen-disease (hay-fever) its diagnosis and treatment. Acta otolar., Stockh., 1934-35, 21: 305-21.—Walton, C. H. A. Pollen disease; report of 111 cases. Manitoba M. Ass. Rev., 1939, 19: 109-14. Also Canad. J. M. Techn., 1939-40, 2: 74-86. ---- seasonal: Geography. Rehsteiner, R. *Beitrage zur Kenntnis der Verbreitung des Heufiebers. 34p. 8? Ziir., 1926. Benjamins, C. E., Idzerda, J., & TJittien, H. [Examination of the plants causing hay-fever in and around Utrecht] Ned. tschr. geneesk., 1926, 70: 935; pt 2, 18.—Bouzat, L. G. Con- tribucion al estudio de la fiebre de heno en la ciudad de Bahia Blanca. Prensa med. argent., 1937, 24: 1359-63.—Derrick, E. Xotes on the causes of hayfever and asthma in Australia. Med. J. AustraUa, 1929, 2: 603-7.—Dunlap, A. M. Allergy as an explanation of vasomotor rhinitis in China. Chin. M. J., 1937, 52: 443-5.—Durham, O. C. Fall hay fever pollens of Canada. Canad. M. Ass. J., 1933. 28: 604-7. ------ Prin- cipal hay fever season marches up map on schedule. Science News Lett., 1941, 40:115.—Gordon, E. Einige Beobachtungen iiber Rhinitis vasomotorica in Aegypten. Fol. otolar. orient., 1932-33, 1: sect. 2, 31-3.—Gutmann, M. J. The first report on hay fever in Palestine. J. Allergy, 1940-41, 12: 182-7.— Hajos, K., & Farago, P. [Hay fever in Hungary] Orv. hetil., 1934, 78: 565.—Hara, H. J. Hay fever among Japanese. Arch. Otolar., Chic, 1934, 20: 668; 1935, 21: 9. ------ Hay fever among Japanese; studies of atmospheric pollen in Tokyo and in Kobe. Ibid., 1939, 30: 525-35.—Hercus, C. E., & Watt, M. N. Hay fever in New Zealand. N. Zealand M. J., 1931, 30: 351-64.—Jamieson, H. C. Hay fever in Alberta. Canad. M. Ass. J., 1937, 36: 595-7.—Kragh, J. [Possibilities of fall hav fever in Denmark; description of a case] Ugeskr. laeger, 1936, 98: 294.—Pirie, J. H. H. Hay fever in South Africa; its causes and treatment (a preliminary communica- tion) J. M. Ass. S. Africa, 1928, 2: 374-82. Also repr.— Scheppegrell. W. Hay fever in Mexico, Central and South America. Med. J. & Rec, 1928, 128: 105-8. Also repr — Sharwood, M. M. The Pollen content of the Melbourne air during the hay fever season of August 1933-March 1934. Med. J. Australia, 1935, 1: 326-32.—Thiberge, N. F. Hay fever in Mexico, Central and South America. Med. J. & Rec, 1929, 129: 502.—Tupynamba, A., & Oliveira Lima, A. A questao da poUenose brasileira. Brasil med., 1940, 54:181-5.— Walton, C. H. A. Pollen disease in Western Canada. Canad. M. Ass. J., 1940, 42: 62-6. ---- seasonal: Geography: Tropics. Benjamins, C. E. [Hay-fever (pollenosis) in Nederlandsch Indie] Geneesk. tschr. Ned. Indie, 1932, 72: 1016, 2 pl. Also Fol. otolar. orient., 1932-33, 1: 105-22—Castellani, A. Rhinitis spastica tropicalis, tropical hay-fever. Sind M. J., 1938. 11: 7-13. Also J. Trop. M. Hyg., Lond., 1938, 41: 98-100.—Ter Heege, F. H. [Tropical hay-fever] Geneesk. tschr. Ned. Indie, 1941, 81: 1231-45. ---- seasonal: Geography: United States. Fasset, N. C, McGary, L., & Bates, L. F. Hayfever plants of the middle west. 52p. 8? Madison, Wis., 1938. Abrams, L. The hay-fever plants of the Western states. Bull. South. Pacific Gen. Hosp., 1932, 1: 162-5.—Abt, A. F. Hay fever in Chicago. J. Am. M. Ass., 1940, 115: 318.— Albert, H., & DeBell, V. Hay fever in Nevada. California West M., 1927, 27: 65-8.—Anderson, J. M. Hay fever plants of Utah. Ibid., 1930, 33: 723.—Balyeat, R. M. A survey of Oklahoma flora, with a study of 121 cases of seasonal hay fever. J. Oklahoma M. Ass., 1926, 19: 59-64. ------ & Rinkel, H. J. Distribution and importance of the paper mulberry (Papyrius papyrifera Kuntze) as a cause of hay fever and asthma in the United States. J. Allergy, 1931, 3: 7-15, pl.—Balyeat, R. M., & Steman, T. R. Hay fever and asthma; distribution and importance of the Acnidas as a cause of hay fever and asthma in the United States. Am. J. M. Sc, 1927, 174: 639-47.—Barrett, C. E. Studies in hay fever; clinical observations including a botanical and air survey of the Utah region. J. AUergy, 1934, 5: 406=26.—Blanton, W. B. Hay fever with comments on the past season in Richmond. Virginia M. Month., 1932, 59: 140-50.—Bozzola, J. A. El problema de la hay fever en los Estados Unidos. Sem. med., 227475—VOL. 7, 4th series----8 B. Air., 1936,43:pt 2,839-41 .—Brown, G. T. Fall hay-fever in the District of Columbia and vicinity. Virginia M. Month., 1926-27, 53: 229-31. ------ Late spring or summer hay- fever in the District of Columbia and vicinity. Ann. Int. M., 1927, 1: 169-78. Also Tr. Am. Ther. Soc (1927) 1928, 28: 31-6. ------ Seasonal hay-fever with special reference to the Middle Atlantic States. J. M. Soc. N. Jersey, 1932, 29: 483-90. Also repr.—Cole, J. A pollen survey in Ames, Iowa, in 1938. J. Iowa M. Soc, 1939, 29: 198-200.—Davison, H. M., Lowance, M. I., & Durham, O. C. The principal hav fever plants and pollens of the South. South. M. J., 1934, 27: 529-35.—Durham, O. C. Hay fever plants and hay fever pollen in Illinois. Illinois M. J., 1933, 63: 574-80. ------ Six fall hav fever seasons in Indiana. J. Indiana M. Ass., 1935, 28: 182-4.—Ellis, R. V., & Rosendahl, C. O. Fall hay fever in the upper Mississippi Valley with special reference to Minne- sota and the Dakotas. J. Lancet, 1932,52: 369-73. ------ A survey of the causes of hay fever for the state of Minnesota. Minnesota M., 1933, 16: 739-89. ------ The diagnosis and treatment of hay fever with especial reference to Minnesota. Ibid., 1934, 17: 378-93.—Feinberg, S. M. Hay fever in the North Central states; its causes and treatment. Illinois M. J., 1932, 61: 429-33. ------& Durham, O. C. Hay fever in Chicago and suburbs; clinical, field and air observations. Ibid., 1933, 63: 464-71.—Foskett, H. H. Some observations on hay fever in the Willamette Valley. Med. Sentinel, 1929, 37: 565-8.—Foss, A. R. Hay fever in Montana. Minnesota M., 1927, 10: 587-93.—French, S. W. Pollens which cause hay fever in South Central Texas. J. Allergy, 1929-30, 1: 286-91.—Huber, H. L. Hay fever in the Chicago territory. IUinois M. J., 1926, 49: 133-8.—Jimenez, B. A survey of sensitization in students of the University of Michigan. J. Michigan M. Soc, 1934, 33: 310-2.—Kahn, I. M., & Grothaus, E. M. Tree pollen hay fever and asthma in the South. South. M. J., 1930, 23: 658-62.—McMinn, H. E., & Graham, E. Another plant causing hay fever in California. J. Allergy, 1936-37, 8: 194.—Maloney, E. S-, & Brodkey, M. H. Hemp pollen sensitivity in Omaha. Nebraska M. J., 1940, 25: 190.—Metzger, F. C. Hay fever in Florida. J. Florida M. Ass., 1932, 19: 18-22.—Penfound, W. T., Efron, B. G., & Morrison, J. J. A survey of the herbaceous plants in New Orleans in relation to allergy. J. Allergy, 1929-30, 1: 369-74.— Piness, G., & McMinn, H. E. The role of the structural fea- tures of pollen grains in identifying the most important hav fever plants of California. J. Lab. Clin. M., 1926-27, 12: 1164-78.—Rackemann, F. M., & Smith, L. B. The hay fever plants of Eastern Massachusetts; a preliminary study. N. England J. M., 1931, 204: 708-10.—Roddis, L. H. Botanical characteristics of some pollens of Hawaii in relation to allergy. Tr. Hawaii M. Ass., 1939, 49: 75-81. Also U. S. Nav. M. Bull., 1940, 38: 206-10.—Rosendahl, C. O., Ellis, R. V., & Dahl, O. A. Air-borne pollen in the Twin Cities area with reference to hay fever. Minnesota M., 1940, 23: 619-35.— Sellers, E. D. Hay fever poUens of the West Texas area. Texas J. M., 1934, 30: 514-7. ------ Pollinosis in the South- west. South. M. J., 1935, 28: 710-4.—Service, W. C. Hay fever flora of the Pikes Peak region. Colorado M., 1934, 31: 311-3.—Slier, R. F. E., Hollister, G., & Bonser, T. A. A botanical survey of hay fever-producing plants in the Pacific Northwest. J. AUergy, 1929-30, 1: 260-79—Suarez, R. M. Informe preliminar de asma, hay fever y otras condiciones al6rgicas en Puerto Rico (basado en el estudio y tratamiento de 204 casos) Bol. As. med. Puerto Rico, 1927, 21: 29-37 — Todd, L. C. Hay fever pollen content of air in Charlotte in 1933; atmospheric and botanical survey in Charlotte in 1933 and its relationship to pollen asthma and hayfever. South. M. & S., 1934, 96: 343-6.—Tuft, L., & Blumstein, G. Incidence and importance of tree pollen hay fever with particular refer- ence to Philadelphia and vicinity. J. Allergy, 1936-37, 8: 464-9.—Vaughan, W. T., Graham, W. R., & Crockett, R. W. Hay fever pollen prevalences in Virginia: review of a 6 year survey. Virginia M. Month., 1933, 60: 158-66.—Waldbott, G. L., & Steere, W. C. Survey of the hay fever situation of Detroit. J. Detroit Coll. M. & S., 1931, 2: 3-9.—Watry, A., & Lamson, R. W. Botanic survey of Needles, California with special reference to the hay fever producing flora. J. Allergy, 1931, 2: 272-81. ------ The probable etiology of pollinosis in Gallup, New Mexico. Ibid., 1934, 5: 166-83.—Weil, C. K. Hay-fever in Alabama; analysis of 100 cases. J. M. Ass. Alabama, 1936-37, 6: 329-34. •------ Summer hay fever of unknown origin in the Southeast. J. Allergy, 1939-40, 11: 361-75.—Wilson, R. A. Some hay-fever problems in the southwest. Southwest J. M. & S., 1934, 18: 46-52—Wode- house, R. P. The hay fever plants of the South. South. M. J., 1941, 34: 986-93. ---- seasonal: Pollen survey. Acquarone, P., & Gay, L. N. A survey of the pollen flora in Baltimore during 1929. J. Allergy, 1931, 2: 336-55.—Aerial pollen survey begun by the Philadelphia College of Pharmacy and Science. Am. J. Pharm., 1934, 106: 389-93.—Baag»k.. 1934, 73: 1021-6.—Houdek, P. K. Pollen statistics for 2 bogs in southwestern Michigan. Papers Michigan Acad. Sc, 1934, 20: 49-56.—Hulsey, S. Pollen counts in Fort Worth, Texas, for the years 1929, 1930 arid 1931. Texas J. M., 1933, 28: 779-81.—Koessler. K. K., & Durham, O. C. A system for an intensive pollen survey; with a report of results in Chicago. J. Am. M. Ass., 1926, 86: 1204-9 — LaRush, F. The pollen content of the air in Toronto, Canada, 1932. J. Allergy. 1934, 5: 306-17.—MacDermot, H. E.f & Howell, G. R. The atmospheric pollen in Montreal. Canad. M. Ass. J., 1936, 34: 316.—Nichol, E. S., & Durham. O. C. A pollen survey of Miami, Florida. South. M. J., 1931, 24: 947.—Oliveira Lima, A., & Greco, J. B. Alergia polinica; um novo tipo de lamina para contagem de polens da atmosfera. Brasil med., 1941, 55: 513.—Rowe, A. H. A study of the at- mospheric pollen and botanic flora of the east shore of San Francisco Bay. J. Lab. CUn. M., 1927-28, 13: 416-39.— Salazar Mall en, M. Estudio de los p61enes de la atm6sfera de la ciudad de Mexico. Rev. Soe. mex. hist, natur., 1939-40 1: 147-64.—Scott, E. B., Criep, L. H.. & Green, M. A. Pollen survey in Pittsburgh, Pennsylvania, 1934. J. Allergy, 1935-36, 7: 80-5.—Sharwood. M. M. Further studies of the poUen content of the Melbourne air. Med. J. Australia, 1937, 1: 117-21. 4 ]il.—Stealy. C. L. The pollen content of the air of San Diego, California. J. Lab. CUn. M., 1936-37, 22: 273-9.— Stroh. J. E. Flora and pollen surveys of Seattle and vicinity Northwest M., 1940, 39: 258-61.—Sylvester, C. B., & Durham! O. C. Ragweed-pollen survey in Maine for 1937. Maine M. J.. 1938, 29: 261-6—Thiberge, N., & Hauser, G. H. The value of atmospheric pollen plates in hay-fever and asthma South. M. J., 1931, 24:1049-53.—Thomas, J. W. A comparison of cedar oil and other materials in the making of slides of atmospheric poUen. J. Lab. Clin. M., 1939-40, 25: 1086-90__ Walton C. H. A & Dudley, M. G. Pollen survey in Manitoba. Canad. M Ass. J., 1940, 42: 430-4.—Wightman, H. B. Studies on the pollen content of the air in New Rochelle New York in 1937. New Rcehelle Hosp. M. Staff Bull., 1938 1- 26-7 — Wilmer, H. B & Cobe, H. M. A note of the quantitative survey of pollen J. Allergy, 1931, 3: 63-8— Wodenhouse, R. P. Atmospheric pollen. Ibid., 1933, 4: 220-6 ch— Zifferblatt. A. H., & Seelaus, H. K. A study of air contamin- ants in the interest of public health; an improved method of poUen survey. Pennsylvania M. J., 1935-36, 39: 67-73. ---- Treatment. Berxton H. S. Hay-fever; what to do about it! /6p. 22}/2cm. ^ ash. [1939] Hollatz M. [F. A.] *Ueber den Catarrhus aestivus und seine Behandlung (Erfahrungen au« dem eigenen Leiden) 30p. S? Grafenhainichen, 1926. Rumbold, T. F. Pruritic rhinitis (hay-fever, autumnal catarrh, etc.) its medical and surgical treatment. 167p. 8? S. Louis, 1885. Urbach, E., & Berger, F. Das Heufieber und seine Behandlung. 180p. 8? Wien, 1937. Alsaker, R. Help for hay fever sufferers. Health Cult., N. Y., 1941, 47: No. 7, 10-2.—Barnes, M. C. Diagnosis and management of allergic rhinitis. Texas J. M., 1939-40, 35: 421-5.—Berggren, S. [On allergic diseases with special regard to hay-fever and its treatment] Sven. lak. tidn., 1926, 23: 825-36.— Bray. G. W. Seasonal hay-fever and its treatment in the British Isles. Med. Press & Circ, Lond., 1933, 135: 250-3.—Brown, A. The diagnosis and treatment of hav fever, Med. lice., N. V., 1934, 139: 571-3.—Bush. L. M. Help f.„ hay fever suft'eiers. Health Cult., N. Y., 1941, 47: No. 5, 10.—Craft, K. L. The treatment of hay fever. Indianapolis M. J., 1930, 33: 275-9.—Dean, L. W., Linton, L. D. [et al.] The treatment of allergic rhinitis. J. Am. M. Ass.. 1937, 108: 251-8.—Ellis, R. V.. & Rosendahl, C. O. Treat hav fever early. Everybody's Health, 1934, 19: No. 8, 2. F.yermann, C. H. The treatment of hay-fever. J. Missouri M. Ass., 1931, 28: 191-4.—Francis, C. Hay-fever and its treatment. Prac- titioner, Lond., 1935, 134: 601-9.—Giroud. P El tratamiento del catarro del heno. Arch, med., Madr., 1927, 26: 588-95.— Hamm. Die Heilung des Heufiebers. Klin. Wschr., 1927, 6: 574.—Hanhart, E. Ueber das Heufieber und seine Bekampfung. Schweiz. med. Wschr., 1928, 58: 662.—Hansen, K. Patogenia y terap6utica de la fiebre del heno. Rev. mid. germ. iber. amer., 1928, 1: 134-40.—Hutter, F. Ueber das Wesen und die Behandlung des Heufiebers. Wien. klin. Wschr., 1926, 39: 657-61.—Hyman, M. Hay fever: symptoms and treat- ment. Eclect. M. J., 1933, 93: 177-81.—Kehr. Wesen, Ursachen und Behandlung des Heufiebers an Hand von iiber 2000 Fallen. Med. Welt, 1934, 8: 365; 404.—Kragh, J. [Ob- servations on allergic rhinitis with special attention on treat- ment of hay-fever] Hospitalstidende, 1934, 77: (Dansk. Oto-laryngol. Selsk. 1'orli.) 59-71.—Lambeth, W. P. Hay fever a specialty. N. Orleans M. & S. J., 1931, 84: 23-8.— Lind-Hansen, Lisbeth [Treatment of hay-fever] Ugeskr. laeger, 1938, 100: 87.—Little, A. H. The treatment of ragweed hay fever. Mississippi Doctor, 1938-39, 16: No. 2, 38-40 — Maloney, E. S. The diagnosis and treatment of hay fever. Nebraska M. J., 1933, 18: 91-5.—Pirera, A. Cura della febbre da fieno. Rinasc. med., 1936, 13: 319.—Stein, J. The treatment of hay fever. J. Med., Cincin., 1933-34, 14: 571-5.—Strosnider, H. O. The management of hay-fever and asthma. Clin. Med., 1926, 33: 309-12.—Szende, B. [Treatment of hay fever and of vasomotor rhinitis] Budapesti orv. ujs., 1932, 30: 628-31.—Tratamiento de la rinitis espas- m6dica. Dfa med., B. Air., 1940, 12: 1013.—Treatment (The) of hay fever. Bull. Lederle Lab., 1935, 3: 43.—Vander Veer, A., jr, Cooke, R. A., & Spain, W. C. Diagnosis and treat- ment of seasonal hayfever. Am. J. M. Sc, 1927, 174: 101-13.— Vaughan, W. T. Nasal pathology as a non-specific factor in the treatment of inhalant allergy. Virginia M. Month., 1934, 60: 598-604—Wier, F. A. ControlUng hay fever. Clin. M. & S., 1936, 43: 217-21.—Withers, O. R. Problems in the treatment of hay fever. Tr. Am. Ther. Soc, 1936, 36: 79-bl. Also J. Kansas M. Soc, 1936, 37: 444-8.—Woenck- haus, E. Heufieber, Heufieberbehandlung und -verhiitung. Med. Klin., BerL, 1938, 34: 993-6.—Wynn, J. Hay fever; the evolution of modern therapeutic concepts. J. Indiana M. Ass., 1928, 21: 327-32. ---- Treatment: Accidents. Dahl, B. Ein Todesfall nach Gebrauch von Helisen (Pollen- mischextrakt) bei Behandlung von Heuasthma. Klin Wschr , 1937, 16: 491-4.—Furstenberg, F. F., & Gay, L. N. The occurence of constitutional reactions in the treatment of hay fever and asthma: analysis of the causative factors. Bull. Johns Hopkins Hosp., 1937, 1: 412-27.—Green, J. E. Con- stitutional reactions in hay fever therapy. Med Clin N. America, 1939, 23: 1255-67.—Joyce, S. J. Critical anaphy- lactic shock during treatment for hay fever: recovery after ? intracardiac iniections of epinephrine. Arch. Int. M., 1937, 60: 974-81. Also repr.—Kahn, I. S. Sensitization of skin induced by turbinal pollen application, resulting in facial acne, case report. J. Allergy, 1938-39, 10: 235-8.—Pollia, J. A. Dermatitis, urticaria and aggravation of nasal symptoms w0ni °l* administration of pollen suspensions. California West M., 1939, 50: 25.—Sternberg, L., & Rosenthal. J. Limiting constitutional reactions in the treatment of hay fever and pollen asthma; an improved treatment schedule. Med. Rec, N. Y., 1939, 149: 14-6. ---- Treatment, biological. Gouze, J. *L'auto-ouro-the>apie; traitement du rhume des foins. 31p. 8? Par., 1934. Balyeat, R. M. Methods of testing hay-fever and asthma patients for protein sensitivity and the selection of correct proteins for treatment. J. Oklahoma M. Ass., 1926, 19: t \ir- 4.pL—"S-eh*n- w- c- Autogenous vaccines in hay fever. J. Michigan M. Soc, 1937, 36: 852.—Boland, E. R., & Lintott HAY FEVER 115 HAY FEVER G. A. M. Results of treatment of rhinorrhoea by injection of protein extracts. Guy's Hosp. Rep., Lond., 1939, 89: 108-11.— Carando, V. A., & Robbio Campos, J. Autoseroterapia endo- nasal en la rinitis espasm6dica. Sem. mid., B. Air., 1937, 44: pt 2, 604-6.—Carlens, E. [Treatment of vasomotor rhinitis with the patient's blood] Nord.med., 1940,8:2103-6 — Darley, W., & Whitehead, R. W. Studies on a urinary pro- teose; skin reactions and therapeutic applications in hay fever. Ann. Int. M., 1932, 6: 389.—Fine Bunkeflod, N. de [Treatment of a case of vasomotor rhinitis with tuberculin] Ugeskr. lteger, 1928, 90: 1091.—Freeman, J. Rush inoculation, with special reference to hay-fever treatment. Lancet, Lond., 1930, 1: 744-7.—Glasschieb, E. Zur Klinik und Therapie der Rhinitis vasomotoria dysproteinica. Mschr. Ohrenh., 1935, 69: 1400-2.—Jacod, M. Les injections intradermiques de peptone dans le traitement du coryza des foins (k propos de 10 malades) Ann. mal. oreiUe, 1928, 47: 460-4.—Keeney, E. L. Histaminase in the treatment of hay fever. J. Am. M. Ass., 1940, 114: 2448.—Llerena Benito, A. Valor tera- peutico de la auto-hemoterapia en el coriza espasmodico aperiodico. Arch, med., Madr., 1928, 28: 58-61.—Matusevich, J., & Bergman, A. La autoorinoterapia en las rinitis espas- m6dica. Rev. espec, B. Air., 1931, 6: 268-80.—Mosso, F. E. Dissensibilizzazione non specifica, col peptone, neUa febbre da fieno, nell'asma e nella corizza spasmodica. Ann. med. nav., Roma, 1926, 2: 311-21.—Muller-dos-Reis, W. Sur le traitement de la rhinite spasmodique par les autolysats de germes neurotropes. Ann. otolar., Par., 1939, 895-7.— Pearson, E. F. Clinical desensitization to wheat by use of an acetylchohne derivative. Ann. Int. M., 1939-40, 13: 2241-5.— Thj0tta, T. The treatment of rhinitis vasomotorica with vaccines; a preliminary report. Acta otolar., Stockh., 1928-29, 13: 329-34.—Urbach, E. Die biologische Behandlung des Heufiebers. Munch, med. Wschr., 1937, 84: 488-90.—Vor- schtitz, J., & Vorschiitz. J. Zur Behandlung des Heuschnu- pfens mit arteigenen CoUantigenen. Med. Welt, 1935, 9: 722. ---- Treatment: Desensitization [and immuni- zation] Plath, W. *Ein Beitrag zur spezifischen .Be- handlung des Heufiebers [Kiel] 21p. 8? [Libau] 1930. Baag0e, K. H. [Treatment of hay-fever with pollen extract] Ugeskr. larger, 1931, 93: 937-40.—Banszky, L. Somatische Betrachtungen iiber Diagnose und desensibilisierende Therapie des Heufiebers. Med. KUn., BerL, 1928, 24: 1086.—Berger, W., & Hansen, K. Ergebnisse und Kritik der spezifischen Desensibilisierung beim Heufieber. Deut. Arch. klin. Med., 1931, 170: 458-69.—Bjorkman, H. Desensibilisierungsbe- handlung bei vasomotorischer Rhinitis. Acta otolar., Stockh., 1938, 26: 555-62.—Bozzola, J. A. Fiebre del heno; su trata- miento por el extracto de polen. Sem. m6d., B. Air., 1931, 38: pt 2, 1497-501.—Brown, A. Studies in hypersensitiveness; on the question of the specificity of the protective effect of the specific treatment of hay fever. J. Immun., Bait., 1928, 15: 301-3.—Cowie, D. M., & Parsons, J. P. The treatment of hay fever and poUen asthma by pollen extracts and changes in local environment. In Contr. Med. Sc. (A. S. Warthin) Ann Arbor, 1927, 253-70.—Credille, B. A. A method of con- troUing the immediate systemic pollen reaction. J. Michigan M. Soc, 1938, 37: 711-5.—Ellis, R. V. Results obtained in treatment of hay fever with pollen extracts. Minnesota M., 1936, 19: 507-10.—Gaehtgens, W. Ueber die spezifische Diagnose und Behandlung des Heufiebers. Med. Klin., BerL, 1933, 29: 422-4. Also repr.—Gelfand, H. H. The determina- tion of factors to explain marginal failure in hay fever desensi- tization. J. AUergy, 1929-30, 1: 222-30.—Gibson, M. M. The specific treatment and prognosis of hay-fever. South- west. M., 1931, 15: 152-4.—Gutmann, M. J. Erfahrungen in der Heufieberperiode 1928 mit der desensibilisierenden Be- handlung. Munch, med. Wschr., 1928, 75: 2090-2. ------ Neues zur Bekampfung des Heufiebers. Jahrkurs. arztl. Fortbild., 1929, 20: H. 2, 35-8. ------■ Erfahrungen uber Pollenallergie (Heuschnupfen, Heufieber, Heuasthma) im Jahre 1929 mit der desensibilisierenden Behandlung. Miinch. med. Wschr., 1929, 76: 1830-3. ------ Ueber die Methoden der spezifischen DesensibiUsierung der PollenaUergie (Heu- fiebers-, Heuschnupfen-, Heuasthma) Ibid., 1935, 82: 599 — Hansen, K. Die Kausaltherapie des Heufiebers durch Desensi- bilisierung. Deut. med. Wschr., 1928, 54: 1447; tab., 1931, 57: 2131. ------ Ueber die Behandlung von Heufieber und Heuasthma. Fortschr. Ther., 1931, 7: 97-101. ------ & Michenfelder. Ergebnis der spezifischen desensibilisierenden Behandlung bei Heufieber im Jahre 1929. Ibid., 1930, 56: 172-4.—Hlavacek, V., & Kotyza, F. [Treatment of hay- fever by injections of pollen extract during 1933-36] Cas. lek. cesk., 1937, 76: 407-9.—Johnson, R. P. The specific treatment of hay fever and pollen asthma in Denver. Rocky Mountain M. J., 1938, 35: 305-10.—Lee, H. J. Comments on pollen therapy; with special reference to its application in Wisconsin. Wisconsin M. J., 1940, 39: 175-8.—Levy. Unsere diesjahrigen Erfahrungen mit desensibilisierender Behand- lung des Heufiebers. In Sitzber. Otolar. Ges. Berlin, 1930, 75-8.—Loeb, L. F., &'Petow, H. Erfahrungen iiber die desensibilisierende Behandlung des Heufiebers. Klin. Wschr., 1927, 6: 57-9.—O'Shaughnessy, E. Hay fever im- munization. Irish J. M. Sc, 1935, 6. ser., 554-55.—Pallestrini, E. Sulla dissensibiUzzazione a scopo terapeutico nelle conzze spasmodiche periodiche. Gior. med. prat., 1924 6: 189-94. Also Gior. Accad. med. Torino, 1924, 4. ser., 30: 113-6.—Petow, H., & Farmer Loeb, F. Erfahrungen 'uber die desensibilisierende Behandlung des Heufiebers. Klin. Wschr., 1929, 8: 968.—Phillips, E. W. Relief of hay-fever by intradermal injections of pollen extracts. J. Am. M. Ass., 1926, 86: 182-4.— Pollenarium for St Mary's hospital, London. Ibid., 1936, 107: 141.—Rosenberg, L. Extraneous factors aggravating seasonal polUnosis; explanation of failures in desensitization with pollen extracts. Med. Rec, N. Y., 1936, 143: 98.—Stier, R. F. E., & Hollister, G. L. Hay fever; results of treatment with pollen extracts. Northwest M., 1926, 25: 655-8.—Szende, B. Erfahrungen mit der spezifischen Desensi- bilisationstherapie des Heuschnupfens und der aspecifischen Desensibilisationstherapie der Rhinitis vasomotoria. Mschr. Ohrenh., 1933, 67: 39-45. ------ [Specific desensitisation therapy of hay fever] Orv. hetil., 1933, 77: [mell.] 35.— Walzer, M. A critical review of the recent literature on physical aUergy, intrauterine sensitization, the mechanism of specific treatment in hay fever, hypersensitiveness in monkeys. J. Allergy, 1937-38, 9: 64-84.—Warwick, H. L. Desensitiza- tion of nasal mucous membranes for the relief of hay fever, asthma and food allergy. Texas J. M., 1934, 30: 210-5.— Wessely, E., & Koerbel, V. Die Kausaltherapie des Heu- fiebers durch DesensibiUsierung. Mschr. Ohrenh., 1931, 65: 412-21. Also Wien. med. Wschr., 1934, 84: 124-30. ---- Treatment: Desensitization: Administra- tion and dosage of allergen. Abramson, H. A. Skin reactions; treatment of hay fever coseasonally by electrophoresis of active constituent of rag- weed extract; preliminary report. N. York State J. M., 1939, 39: 1611-3. Also J. Allergy, 1940-41, 12: 169-75.—Alperstein, B. B. Oral vs parenteral pollen therapy; a clinical study. Ibid., 1939-40, 11: 498-508.—Bernstein, T. B., & Feinberg, S. M. Oral ragweed pollen therapy; clinical results of experi- ments on gastrointestinal absorption. Arch. Int. M., 1938, 62: 297-304.—Bernstein, C, jr, & Kirsner, J. B. Oral pollen therapy; experimental considerations. J. Allergy, 1936-37, 8: 221-7.—Black, J. H. The oral administration of pollen. J. Lab. Clin. M., 1926-27, 12: 1156-9.—Brown, G. T. Maxi- mum dosage in pollen therapy. J. Allergy, 1932, 3: 180-91. Also repr. •---— Further experiences with maximum dosage pollen therapy. Ibid., 1934, 6: 86-92. Also repr—D'Eleia, A. S. Artificially pollenized atmosphere in treatment of hay fever; preUminary report. Med. J. & Rec, 1933, 138: 181-7.— Duke, W. W. New method of administering pollen extract for purpose of preventing reactions; a subcuticular method. J. Am. M. Ass., 1930, 94: 767-71. Also repr.—Dundy, H. D.. Levin, L., & Marko'w, H. Ragweed hay fever; the effect of dosage in the treatment of 314 cases. J. Lab. Clin. M., 1938- 39, 24: 583-6.—Forman, J. Status of oral pollen therapy of hay-fever and asthma. Ohio M. J., 1939, 35: 522.—Francis, C. Intranasal application of pollen solution in hay fever. Brit. M. J., 1938, 1: 1263.—Fromer, J. L., & McFarland, M. D. The pollen injection treatment of hay fever; the perennial method. Lahey Clin. Bull., 1940, 2: 38-40.—Gatterdam, E. A., jr. Oral administration of pollen extracts, hay-fever and asthma therapy. Southwest. J. M. & S., 1933, 17: 199- 202.—Hansel, F. K. Coseasonal intracutaneous treatment of hay fever. J. Allergy, 1940-41, 12: 457-69.—Jimenez, B. Coseasonal intradermal treatment of hay fever. Am. J. Dis. Child., 1937, 53: 1412.—Joltrain, E., & Diard, L. La maladie du pollen (rhume et asthme des foins) diagnostic des substance sensibilisantes et traitement par cuti-reactions et inhalations d'extraits de pollens. Presse med., 1930, 38:793-7.—Koschade, R. Kausalbehandlung des Heufiebers und anderer Formen der allergischen Diathese (Ekzem, Urtikaria, Migrane) durch Perkutantherapie. Miinch. med. Wschr., 1937, 84: 614.— Nicholson, D. The importance of specific poUens and their optimum dosage for desensitization in hay fever; from an experience of 5 years. Canad. M. Ass. J., 1926, 16: 683-6.— Peshkin, M. M. Critique of the perennial treatment of pollen allergy. J. Allergy, 1935-36, 7: 477-519.—Phillips, E. W. ntradermal pollen therapy during the attack. Ibid., 1933, 5: 29-36.—Rackemann, F. M. The optimal dosage in the treatment of hay fever. J. Immun., Bait., 1926, 11: 91-121.— Rinkel, H. J. Coseasonal hay fever therapy, with special reference to low pollen doses. Clin. M. & S., 1935, 42: 426-9 — Rockwell, G. E. Clinical results in the prevention and treat- ment of hay-fever by oral administration of pollens of the grass and ragweed types. Ohio M. J., 1938, 34: 784-7.------ Clinical study of oral poUen therapy. Physician's Bull., 1940, 5: 67-71.—Schwartz, S. C. Oral pollen therapy. J. Lab. CUn. M., 1939-40, 25: 566-75.—Seyler, L. E. Specific therapy in co-seasonal management of hay-fever; the importance of controUed variation of the dosage. Ohio M. J., 1941, 37: 768-70 —Waldbott, G. L., & Ascher, M. S. The optimal doses in pollen therapy. J. Allergy, 1936-37, 8: 457-63—Wovschin. W. A. A local immunity therapy for hay fever; a supplementary report. Med. Rec, N. Y., 1935, 141: 297-300. ---- Treatment: Desensitization: Allergens, atopens, and their preparation. Anderson, J. M. A new method of preparation of poUen extracts. J. AUergy, 1934-35, 6: 244-6.—Benjamins, C. E. HAY FEVER 116 HAY FEVER Die biologische Artspezifizitiit der Grjiser und ihre Bedeutung fiir die Behandlung des Heufiebers. Zschr. Hals ito. Heilk., 1928, 20: 221-6 [Discussion] 291-301. ---- Idzerda. J., & Nienhuis, J. H. Die biologische Artspezifitat dei (irascr und ihre Bedeutung fiir die Behandlung des Heufiebers. Ibid., 1929, 23: 436-43.—Black, J. H.. & Moore, M. C. Pollen therapy with protein-free extracts. J. Am. M. Ass., 1926, 86: 324.—Boatner, C. H., & Efron, B. G. Studies with antigens; purification of extracts of grass pollens. Proc. Soc. Exp. Biol., N. Y, 1940, 45: 460-2.—Brown, A. On the question of the identity of the atopens of the pollens of high ragweed and low ragweed. J. Immun., Bait., 1927, 13: 73-8. ------ The use of glvcerolated pollen extracts in the treatment of hay fever. J." Allergy, 1933, 4: 468-72.—Coca, A. F., & Milford, K. L. Chemical standardization of pollen extracts. Ibid., 1935-36, 7: 337-10.— Cohen, M. B. A note on a new method of preserving pollen and dust extracts. Ibid., 1938-39, 10: 385.—Concentrated pollen antigens-Lederle. J. Am. M. Ass., 1938, 110: 741.—Cooke, R. A., Vander Veer, A., & Barnard, J. H. The treatment of hay fever with standardized pollen extracts based on the new unit of protein nitrogen. J. Allergy, 1933, 4: 163-8.—Cooke, R. A., & Stull, A. The preparation and standardization of pollen extracts for the treatment of hay fever. Ibid., 87-91.—Eagle, H., Arbesman, C, sensitive patients. Med. Rec, N. Y., 1938, 148: 174-li. Strebel, J. 1 ebci spezifische Behandlung des Heufiehers (Pollenuberempfindlichkeit) mit der Polljsat- methode. Schweiz. med. Wschr., 1927, 57: 402. ------ Die desensibilisierende Behandlung des Heufiebers oder der Pollenuberempfindlichkeit mit der Pollysatmethode. Praxis, Bern, 1932, 21: 169.—Stull, A., Cooke, R. A. [et al.] Experi- mental and clinical study of fresh and modified pollen extracts. J. Allergy, 1939-40, 11: 439-65.—Sullivan, C. J., & Vaughan, W. T. Highly concentrated pollen extracts and their detet iora- tion in various media. Ibid., 1938-39, 10: 551-60- Thiberge, N. The effect of gastric digestion on the allergic power of pollen. N. Orleans M. & S. J., 1939-40, 92: 430-3.—Unger, L.. & Moore, M. B. Studies on pollen and pollen extracts; dextrose poUen extracts: therapeutic results in 1933. J. Allergy, 1934, 5: 561-7.------The eilects of varying hydro- gen ion concentration upon the stabiliu of pollen extracts. Ibid., 1936-37, 8: 22-5. Irbach. K. Die Behandlung des Heufiebers mittels artspezifischei Graserbluten-Propeptane beziehungsweise Pollen-Mikromahlzeiten. Klin. Wsehr., 1933, 12: 1797-801. ------ Perorale Behandlung des Heufiebers mittels Griisersamen und Baumbliiten. Deut. Heilpflanze, 1937-38, 4: 70. ------ Deallergisierung des Heuschnupfens und des Heuasthmas mittels papainisierter und peptonisierter Griisersamen. Wien. klin. Wschr.. 1937, 50: 252-7.—Wirth. Die Diagnose und Therapie des Heuschnupfens mit Pollen- extrakten (Helisen) Zschr. Lar\ ng., 1931-32, 22: 179-86.— Zoss, A. R., Koch, C. A., & Hirose, R. S. Alum-ragweed precipitate: preparation and clinical investigations. J. Allergy 1936-37, 8:329-35. ---- Treatment: Diet. Beckman, H. The acid treatment of hay fever. Med. J. & Rec, 1929, 130: 9-14. ------ A note on the acid treatment of hay fever. Wisconsin M. J., 1932, 31: 533-5.—Benjamins, C. E. Eine aUmentare Theorie des Entstehens von Heufieber und eine darauf begriindete Diat. Zschr. Hals &c Heilk., 1931-32, 30: 473-86. Also Ned. tschr. geneesk., 1932, 76: 539; 1933, 77: 891. ------ Diat fur Heufieberpatienten. Zschr. Hals &c Heilk., 1933, 33: 153-6.—Disertori, B., & Raffaeta, D. Terapia acidificante della corizza da fieno. Policlinico, 1937, 44: sez. prat., 877-80.—Glasscheib, A. Ueber den Einfluss der Ernahrung auf die Rhinitis vaso- motoria. Mschr. Ohrenh., 1928, 62: 168-70. ------ Die nutritiv allergische Theorie des Heufiebers und ihre Bedeutung fiir die Therapie (vorlaufige Mitteilung) Ibid., 1932, 66: 586.—Halasz, G. Von der Behandlung der Rhinitis vaso- motoria durch Versauerungsmethode. Ibid., 1937, 71: 1354- 8.—Lenormand, J. Acidothirapie amin£e et rhume des foins. Presse med., 1933, 41: 1141.—Rinkel, H. J. The treatment of seasonal hay fever: the value of a prescribed diet as an adjunct to specific pollen therapy. Clin. M. & S., 1936, 43: 211-6. ---- Treatment: Drugs. Abramson, H. A. Tannic acid therapv in allergy of the nasal mucosa. N. York State J. M., 1937, 37: 1919-21.— Armenio, O. A. II fenolo nella terapia della rinite vasomotoria. Arch. ital. otol., 1936, 48: 721-7.—Balyeat, R. M. Clinical use of ephedrin in the treatment of asthma and hay-fever. J. Oklahoma M. Ass., 1927,20: 3-8.—Beckman, H. Nitro- hydrochloric acid in the treatment of hay fever. Am. J M. Sc. 1927, 174: 525-9. Also Wisconsin M. J., 1928, 27: 253-5 — Bergara, R., & Bergara, C. Las inyecciones esclerosantes en las rinitis vasomotrices; sus resultados. Rev. As. med. argent., 1933, 47: 2760-74.—Bloom, B. The use of potassium salts '" hay fever; preliminary report. J. Am. M. Ass., 1938, 111: ?}■■—Cruciani, J. A. El acido cr6mico en las rinitis espas- m&dicas. Sem. med., B. Air., 1937, 44: pt 2, 706-8. ------ Cuatro cases de rinitis espasm6dica tratados por'el axido cromico. Ibid., 1938, 45: 633-6. ------ La rinitis espas- modica y su tratamiento por el dcido cr6mi co. Ibid., 1448-50 — D'Ottone, L. Tratamiento de la rinitis espasmddica por el hiposulnto de magnesio. An. otorinolar. Uruguay, 1937, 7: 5o-63.—Engelsher, D. L. Potassium chloride in hay-fever ?n?n«J?r *llerg'es; a personal study of 97 cases. Ohio M. J., 1940, 36: 949.- Fernandez Soto, E. Acerca del tratamiento del coriza espasmedico y sus equivalentes, por las pequenas dosis de todo Lev. med. cir. Habana, 1934, 39: 413-9 — r isnor, 1' K. I reatment of vasomotor rhinitis and alUed condi- Vi°-jnSnW,t£ aodlum■ morrhuate. Arch. Otolar., Chic, 1938, 27: nh?v"t?aarde;iF- •*-, & Maytum- C. K. The treatment H..» P F * v— J- Lab. Clin M., 1926-27, 12: 1203.- nift Biene^iff uvm' w " u Dle Behandlung des Heufiebers mit Bienengift. Klin. Wschr., 1936, 15: 1321 —Hal4sz G [Acid treatment of rhiniti. vasomotorica] Orv. hetil 1937' bl rullI e Fail? Jn„ 7pk-8'-2 ■" K°fler' K Zwei "»* Viperin HAY FEVER 117 HAY FEVER m6dica. Dia med., B. Air., 1941, 13: 495.—Leiri, F. [Treat- ment of 2 cases of vasomotor rhinitis by irrigations with a calcium chloride solution] Fin. lak. sail, hand., 1929, 71: 197-9.—Levine, M. Free iodine in the treatment of vaso- motor rhinitis and the symptom complex of sneezing and nasal hydrorrhea; preliminary report. Laryngoscope, 1933, 43: 39-41.—Lewy, A. Sodium iodide in hyperesthetic rhinitis. Arch. Otolar., Chic, 1931, 13: 97.—Madsen, E. G. [Treat- ment of vasomotor rhinitis with torantil] Ugeskr. laeger, 1939, 101: 441-3.—Mechner, A. Schlangengiftsalbe gegen Rhinitis vasomotoria und Schnupfen; vorlaufige Mitteilung. Wien. med. Wschr., 1936, 86: 1065-7.—Meyer, E. A. Free iodine therapy in the treatment of vasomotor rhinitis. Hahne- man. Month.", 1934, 69: 668-70—Mollison, W. M. The drug tieatment of spasmodic rhinorrhoea. Brit. M. J., 1929, 2: 1052.—Nussbaum, R. Phocajod als Heufiebermittel. Deut. med. Wschr., 1926, 52: 880. ------ Heuasthma und Er- fahrungen mit Phocajod. Med. Klin., BerL, 1927, 23: 1067 — Palmer, A. The effect of phenol in hyperesthetic rhinitis with tissue studv of the nasal mucosa. Ann. Otol. Rhinol., 1935, 44: 25-32.—Rappaport, B. Z., & Reed, C. I. Viosterol of high potency in seasonal hay fever and related conditions. J. Am. M. Ass., 1933, 101: 105-9.—Reuys. H. Die Behandlung von Rhinitis vasomotorica und anderen entziindlichen Er- krankungen der Nase mit einem neuen Mittel (Xvlidrin) Med. Klin., BerL, 1937, 33: 838-40. ------ Die Therapie des Heuschnupfens mit Xylidrin. Med. Welt, 1938, 12: 962.—Rhume (Le) des foins; son traitement par le pressyl. J. med. Paris, 1937, 57: 391.—Rubin, S. S., Aaronson, A. L. [et al.] Potassium salts in the treatment of pollinosis; a clinical evaluation. J. Am. M. Ass., 1940, 114: 2359.—Rusk, H. A., Dean, L. W., jr, & Rindskopf, W. Results of potassium therapy in nasal allergy. Ann. Otol. Rhinol, 1940, 49: 76-9.— Simeoni, C. La terapia sclerosante nella rinite vasomotoria. Arch. ital. otol., 1936, 48: 185-91.—Spivacke, C. A. Vaso- motor rhinitis treated with pure carbolic acid. J. Allergy, 1933, 4: 408-13.—Sternberg, H. Der Kokain-Adrenalin- Schnupfen als Therapeutikum; gleichzeitig ein Beitrag zur pharmakologischen Beeinflussung der Gewebsdurchlassigkeit der Schleimhaut der Luftwege. ■ Zschr. Laryng., 1929, 18: 103-15. ------ & Sugar, M. Ueber therapeutische Beein- flussung nasaler Hypersekretionen (Rhinitis vasomotoria) durch kleine Joddosen (vorlaufige Mitteilung) Wien. klin. Wschr., 1926, 39: 416. Also Zschr. Hals &c Heilk., 1926, 15: 357-63.—Sterling, A. The value of phosphorus and calcium in asthma, hay fever, and allied diseases. J. Lab. Clin. M., 1927-28, 13: 997-1005.—Thommen, A. A. The inefneacy of intravenous calcium injections in asthma, hay fever, and allied conditions. N. York State J. M., 1926, 26: 665.—Weil, M. Ueber die Lokalbehandlung der Rhinitis vasomotoria. Wien. med. Wschr., 1931, 81: 1605. ---- Treatment: Drugs: Iontophoresis. Shields, C. Hay fever; with special reference to treatment by intranasal ionization. 57p. 8? Lond., 1937. Alden, A. M. Iontophoresis in allergic rhinitis. Tr. Am. Lar. Rhin. Otol. Soc, 1936, 42: 421-4. ------ A year's work with ionization in the treatment of hay-fever. Laryngo- scope, 1934, 44: 741-4.—Alexander, H. L., & Alexander, J. H. Ionization of the nasal mucosa; relationship between reagins in the blood and effect of treatment. J. Allergy, 1934-35, 6: 240-3.—Barrett, H. A. Galvanic ionization therapy in allergic rhinitis as employed at the Manhattan Eye, Ear and Throat Hospital. Laryngoscope, 1936, 46: 262-5.—Bernheimer, L. B. Zinc ionization in nasal allergy. J. Am. M. Ass., 1936, 106: 1980.—Bryant, B. L. Ionization in hay fever: indications, technic, scope. Arch. Phys. Ther., 1935, 16: 613-7. ------ The Warwick ionization treatment for hay fever and hyper- esthetic rhinitis with report of cases. J. Med., Cincin., 1934-35, 15: 598-601. Also Ohio M. J., 1936, 32: 726-32.—Cottrell, S. M. The treatment of hayfever by ionization; case reports. Virginia M. Month., 1938, 65: 24-8.—Dean, L. W. The funda- mentals of allergic rhinitis, with particular reference to ioniza- tion (iontophoresis) Tr. Am. Laryng. Ass., 1936, 48: 196- 212. Also Ann. Otol. Rhinol., 1936, 45: 326-38. ------ Linton, L. D. [et al.] The treatment of allergic rhinitis with particular reference to ionization and the control of chronic vasomotor rhinitis. Tr. Am. Acad. Ophth. Otolar., 1936, 41: 129-49.—Demetriades, T. D. Zur Behandlung der vaso- motorischen Storungen der Nase durch Iontophorese (Rhino- Kataphorese) Mschr. Ohrenh., 1927, 61: 524-33.—Franklin. P. Treatment of hay fever by intranasal zinc ionization. Brit. M. J., 1931, 1: 1115. ------ Intranasal treatment by ionization in hay fever, vasomotor rhinitis, and ozaena. Ibid., 1932, 1: 751. ------ The value of intra-nasal ionisation. Med. Press & Circ, Lond., 1935, 190: 281-4. ----— Man- agement of a hay-fever ionization clinic; a comparative statis- tical survey of results in 1937 and 1938. Brit. M. J., 1939, 1: 871.—Gale, J. Zinc ionization in the treatment of intumescent rhinitis. Arch. Phys. Ther., 1929, 10: 486-8.—Garfin, S. W., & Pearl, S. M. Ionization in the treatment of hay fever and allied conditions. N. England J. M., 1936. 214: 244-7. ch.—Hansel, F. K. Status of ionization in nasal allergy. Arch. Phys. Ther., 1938, 19: 489-98.—Harris, M. L. Zinc ionization in intumes- cent rhi-itis. Ibid., 1935, 16: 97-104.—Haseltine. B. Ioniza- tion in the treatment of nasal hyperesthesia.- Eye Ear &c. Month., 1934, 13: 257-61.------The place of ionization in the treatment of hay fever. Clin. M. & S., 1935, 42: 159; 1936, 43: 221.—Hayden, A. A. Ionization for hyperesthetic rhinitis: a preliminary report. Arch. Otolar., Chic, 1935, 22: 393-9.—Hays, H. Ionization of the nasal mucosa for hay fever, hyperesthetic rhinitis and certain types of asthma. Med. Rec, N. Y., 1935, 141: 23-5. ------ Ionization treatment of hay fever. J Am. M. Ass., 1936, 106: 643. ------ Zinc ionization (Warwick method) in the treatment of hay fever and allied conditions. Med. Times, N. Y., 1936, 64: 6.—Histopathologic studies of nasal zinc ionization. Arch. Phys. Ther., 1936, 17: 44-6.—Hoi lender, A. R. Intranasal zinc ionization; its fundamental aspects and clinical value. Ibid., 1934, 15: 581-7. ------ Further studies with zinc ionization in nasal allergy. Ibid., 1935, 16: 359-62. ------ Newer aspects of ionization therapy in nasal allergic disorders. Ibid., 1936, 17: 216-24. ------ Ionization as a prolonged palliative in vasomotor rhinitis. Arch. Otolar., Chic, 1935, 21: 448-55. ------ Vasomotor rhinitis: evaluation of thera- peutic procedures with special reference to ionization. Eye Ear &c Month., 1936-37, 15: 337-40. ------• & Gorin, M. Influence of ionization on vasomotor rhinitis. Illinois M. J., 1935, 68: 493-8.—Honiss, J. R. The ionization of nasal membranes for the relief of hay fever, asthma and food allergy. J. Am. Inst. Homeop., 1935, 28: 471-7. ------ Review of results of cases ionized for hay fever in 1934 and 1935. Ibid., 1936, 29: 222-7— Hurd, L. M. The treatment of hay fever and hyperesthetic rhinitis by ionization. Tr. Am. Laryng. Ass., 1935, 41: 109-18. Also Arch. Otolar., Chic, 1935. 22: 416-24. Also N. York State J. M., 1935, 35: 965-72 Also Rev. med. cir. Habana, 1935, 40: 827-38— Hurlbut, J. A. Treatment of hay fever by ionization method. Wisconsin M. J., 1935, 34: 93.—Ionization in certain nasal conditions. Bull. Pract. Ophth., S. Franc, 1936, 6: 30-2.—Joyce, S. J. Ionization for nasal allergy. J. Michigan M. Soc, 1936, 35: 447-55.—McCaskey, C. H. Zinc ionization in hay fever. Tr. Indiana Acad. Ophth. Otolar., 1934, 112-5— Macfarlan, D. Ionization for hay fever. Week. Roster, Phila., 1935, 30: 1503.-—McLachlin, J. H. The ionization treatment of hay- fever. Eclect. M. J., 1935, 95: 287-9. Also Nat. Eclect. M. Ass. Q., 1936, 28: 24-6— McMahon, B. J. The early and late effects of ionization upon the mucosa of the frontal sinuses of dogs. Week. Bull. S. Louis M. Soc, 1935, 29: 500-2.—Miller, C. M. Hyperaesthetic rhinitis (hay fever) treatment by zinc ionization. Virginia M- Month., 1935-36, 62: 11-4.—Mont- gomery, D. C. Ionization treatment in hay fever. Tr. Am. Lar. Rhin. Otol. Soc., 1936, 42: 503-9— Payne, V. L. My results with ionization treatment in nasal allergy. J. Arkansas M., Soc, 1936-37, 33: 156-9. Also Tristate M. J., 1936-37, 9: 1727-9.—Ramirez, M. A. Disappointing results from the ionization treatment for hay fever. J. Am. M. Ass., 1936, 106: 281. Also Nebraska M. J., 1936, 21: 325.—Shields, C. The ionization treatment of hay fever.. Practitioner, Lond., 1936, 136: 645-8. Also Zschr. arztl. Fortbild., 1937, 34: 16 — Tempea, V. Le sulfate de zinc dans le traitement des rhinites vasomotrices. Ann. otolar., Par., 1940, 277-80.—Tobey, H. G. Experiences in ionization of the nasal mucous membrane. Tr. Am. Laryng,. Ass., 1935, 41: 302-4. Also N. England J. M., 1935, 213: 230.—Van Osdol, H. A. Zinc ionization in hay fever. Tr. Indiana Acad. Ophth. Otolar., 1934, 115-29 — Voik, L. D. Iontophoresis in hay fever and allergic conditions. Laryngoscope, 1935, 45: 607-19.—Walker, G. W. Ionization treatment in hay fever. California West. M., 1935, 42: 263. ------Walker, J. R., & Walker, B. F. Ionization treatment of hay fever. Arch. Phys. Ther., 1935, 16: 549-51.—Warwick, H. L. Treatment of hay-fever and its allied conditions by ionization; preUminary report. Laryngoscope, 1934, 44: 173-81. ---- Treatment: Duration. Brown, A. A new plan for applying the specific treatment of pollen hay fever (perennial treatment) J. Immun., Bait., 1927, 13: 273-9. Also Bull. N. York Acad. M., 1927, 3: 536-8. Also J. Allergy, 1932, 3: 113-9.—Colmes, A. The perennial treatment of hav fever; a comparative study. J. Lab. CUn. M., 1934, 19: 481-5.—Figley. K. D. The continuous method of hay fever treatment. J. Allergy, 1930-31, 2: 39-42. Also Ohio M. J., 1933, 29: 360-4.—Fineman, A. H., & Stern, A. Intensive treatment of hay fever; comparative study of the preseasonal, perennial and coseasonal methods. Med. Rec, N. Y., 1938, 148: 113-6.—Freund, E. M. Perennial or year round treatment of hay fever with special reference to pollens in the capital district of New York State. Ibid., 1935, 141: 357-60.—Scheopegrell, W. The intensive treatment for hav. fever. Pub. Health Rep., Wash.. 1926, 41: 827-30. Also Cincinnati J. M., 1926-27, 7: 407-10.—Schiff. N. S. The long interval vs the short interval treatment of hay fever. Ann. Int. M., 1929-30, 3: 690-9.—Spain, W. C. & Fuchs, A. M. A clinical study of the advantages of the perennial treatment of hay fever. South. M. J., 1937, 30: 1199-208.—Stewart, Z. W. Throughout the year treatment of hav fever. Med. Woman J., 1931, 38: 249-51.—Strebel. J. Allergie und vasku- lare Hypotonic; Vererbung der Allergiekongruenzen; Be- handlung dis Heufiebers im hyperergischen Stadium und in der floriden Zeit. Klin. Mbl. Augenh., 1938, 100: 243-57.— Sutherland. C. The perennial treatment of hay fever. Med. J. Australia, 1933, 2: 373.—Vaughan, W. T. An improved coseasonal therapy. J. Allergy, 1932, 3: 542-7,—Veer. A. V. HAY FEVER 118 HAY FEVER The relative merits of seasonal and perennial treatment of hay fever. Ibid., 1935 -36. 7: 578-81. ---- Treatment: Electrotherapy, and thermo- therapy. Didsbury, G. Traitement des coryzas vaso-moteurs et du rhume des> foins par l'electrolyse bipolaire interstitielle. J. med. Paris, 1924, 43: 652-4.—Lewi, W. G. Hay fever arid asthma; report of results in treating 150 cases with high frequency electricity at the General Electric Plant at Schenec- tady during the season of 1925. N. York State J. M., 1926, 26: 489-94.—Sinsky, H. L. Chronic hypersensitive rhinitis with resultant asthma; its treatment and relief by diathermy. Eye Ear &c Month., 1932, 11: 431-6.—Tamari, M. Zur Diathermiebehandlung der Rhinitis vasomotoria. Zschr. Hals &c Heilk., 1932, 31: 490-9 [Discussion] 506. ---- Treatment: Evaluation. Alexander, H. L. The treatment of hay fever by speciaUsts in the United States and Canada; report of an inquiry. J. Allergy, 1933, 4: 169-76.—Baldwin, L. B., & Glaser. J. Effect of treatment on skin and mucous membrane sensitivity and on reagins in hay fever. Ibid., 1936-37, 8: 129-42— Barlow, D. L. Some reasons for failure in the treatment of hav fever. Med. J. AustraUa, 1932, 1: 436.—Chamberlain, C. f. Ob- servations on the treatment of hay fever in the Pacific North- west; 53 cases. Ann. Otol, Rhinol., 1927, 36: 1083-92.— Cohen, A. E. Symposium on hay fever; the present status of methods used in the treatment of hay fever. Kentucky M. J., 1935, 33: 24-6.—Colmes, A., & Rackemann, F. M. Further observations on the changes in skin tests following specific pollen therapy. J. Allergy, 1933. 4: 473-80. Also repr.— Cunningham, T. D., & Wolfe, A. M. Summary of results of 10 years' hay fever treatment. Ibid., 1932. 4: 48-50.—Eyer- mann, C. H. Considerations in evaluating the therapy of hay fever. South. M. J., 1940, 33: 190! Feinberg, S. M. Hay fever treatment; factors leading to maximum results. Clin. M. & S., 1928, 35: 309-12. ------ A method of evalua- tion of results in hay fever; its application to certain modes of treatment. Ann. Int. M., 1933, 6: 1153-60.—Gelfand, H. H. Problem of failure in present-day management of hay fever; the importance of extra-pollen hypersensitivity in treatment. Arch. Otolar., Chic, 1932, 16: 550-5. Also repr.—Haiman, J. A. Consumate end results in vasomotor rhinitis. Med. Rec. N. V., 1937, 145: 117-20.—Harley, D. Hay fever; the ellcct of pollen therapy on the skin reactions; a reaction- inhibiting substance in the serum of treated patients. J. Path. Bact.. Lond., 1937, 44: 589-601.—Henry, J. P. Some causes of failure in the treatment of seasonal hay fever. Mem- phis M. J., 1929, 6: 219-23.—Kern, R. A. Seasonal (pollen) hay fever with negative skin tests; results of treatment. Ann. CUn. M., 1926-27, 5: 371-3. ------ Some causes of failures in hay-fever treatment. Med. CUn. N. America, 1926, 10: 47-5(i. —Levin, S. J. The effect of massive pollen therapy on skin test sensitivity . J. Allergy, 1936-37, 8: 26-38.—Markow, H., A- Spain. W. C. The effect of consecutive years of treat- ment upon cutaneous sensitiveness in late hay fever. Ibid., 1933, 4: 363-6.------■ Further observations concerning the effect of pollen therapy upon cutaneous sensitiveness in late hay fever. Ibid., 1934-35, 6: 227-30.—Rackemann, F. M. The results of the specific treatment of late hay fever J Immun., Bait., 1926, 11: 81-9.—Ramirez, M. A. Statistical report on the treatment of hay fever. Am. J. M. Sc, 1928 176: 856-65.—Sherman, W. B. Changes in serological re- actions and tissue-sensitivity in hay-fever patients during the early months of treatment. J. Immun., Bait., 1941 40- 289-309. ----— Stull. A.. & Cooke, R. A. Serologic changes in hay fever cases treated over a period of years. J. Allergy 1939-40, 11: 225-44.—Sterling, A. The successful treatment of hay fever and pollen asthma. Ann. Int. M., 1932 6- 400-3 Also Pennsylvania M. J., 1933, 36: 899-901.—Sternberg, l' The effect of pollen therapy upon the common cold in hay- fever subjects. N. York State J. M., 1935, 35: 713.—Vander Veer, A.. & Clarke, J. A., jr. Permanent results following treatment for late hay fever. J. Allergy, 1934-35. 6: 551-5 — Waldbott. G. I.. The causes of failure of the pollen treatment for hay fever. J. Michigan M. Soc, 1930, 29: 567-9.—Walker I. C. One hundred cases of apparently cured pollen hay-fever' J Am. M. Ass. 1928 90: 750-3.-Wein. Z. [Experiments in the treatment of hayfever] Orv. hetil., 1926, 70: 1120-3. ---- Treatment: Hormones, and organ ex- tracts. Del Turco. L. Contributo alia terapia tiroidea della corizza da fieno Med. nuova, 1933, 24: 380-91.-Joseph, B. Insulin as an additive treatment in hay fever and hay asthma. Med Rec N Y 1939. 149: 16-20.-Keeney. E. L. Epinephrine in oil; its effect m the symptomatic treatment of hay fever J. Allergy, 1938-39, 10: 590-5.-Maduro, R. Deuxcas de n^™ sPasmodlf extract of the intestinal mucosa in the treatment of vasomotor -rhinitis Ann. Int. M., 1939-40, 13: 2235-40.—Schmidt, P. Ueber die Leberbehandlung des Heufiebers und Asthmas. Med. Klin., BerL, 1933, 29: 1616.—Spiess, G. Der Einfluss endoknner Driisenextrakte, insbesondere der Thymusdriise auf Asthma, Heuschnupfen u. a. Zschr. Hals &c Heilk., 1927-28, 18: 250-5 [Discussion] 293-7.—Veils, C. Hypophysenextrakt in der Therapie der vasomotorischen Rhinitiden. Ibid., 1927, 9: 132-8. ---- Treatment: Miscellaneous methods. Ahrent, F. Ein Beitrag zur Heufieberbehandlung. Zschr. Laryng., 1932, 23: 236-8.—Alexander, H. L. Hay fever. In Modern Med. Ther. (Barr, D. P.) Bait., 1940, 1: 988-1001.— Alfdldy, J. [Recent tretment of vasomotor rhinitis] Budapesti orv. ujs., 1937, 35: 1177-9.—Beckman, H. Treatment of hay- fever by desensitisation and with acid. Lancet, Lond., 1933, 1: 1227-9.—Bonjour, J. Le traitement abortif des rhumes et du rhume des foins. Schweiz. med. Wschr., 1927, 57: 598.—Bonjour de Rachewsky. La suggestion et le rhume des foins. Presse med., 1930, 38: 1124.—Brauns, W. Zur Be- handlung der allergischen Erkrankungen, insbesondere des Heufiebers. Med. Welt, 1933, 7: 559-62.—Bubert. H. M. Hay fever; the present status of treatment. Bull. School M. Univ. Maryland, 1939, 24: 10-22.—Burgess, T. S. The local treatment of vasomotor-rhinitis. J. M. Ass. Georgia, 1935, 24: 263-5.—Byrd, H. Hay fever, its control through efferent interception. Ann. Int. M., 1929-30, 3: 850-5.—Chamberlain, C. T. Observations on the treatment of hay fever in the Pacific Northwest. Tr. Am. Lar. Rhin. Otol. Soc, 1927, 33: 180-9.—Cohen, S. Allergic rhinitis; a rhinological treatment. Med. Rec, N. Y., 1940, 152: 178-81.—Colmes, A. Notes on the treatment of hay fever. J. Allergy, 1933, 4: 98-104. Also repr.—Czerny, A. Zur Therapie rhinogener Kopfschmerzen und vasomotorischen Schnupfens. Deut. med. Wschr., 1936, 62: 1759.—Dutton, L. O. Management of hay fever and asthma in general practice. Southwest. M., 1938, 22: 270-2.— Eggston, A. A. Practical suggestions for nurses handling hay fever patients. Trained Nurse, 1927, 78: 610-3.—Elsbach, E. J. A new treatment for hay fever. N. York State J. M., 1941, 41: 1248.—Ertl, E. Zur Therapie des Heuschnupfens. Aerztl. Prax., Wien, 1939, 13: 183-5. Also Wien. kUn. Wschr., 1939, 52: 643-5.—Felderman, L. Treatment of allergic rhinitis. Med. World, 1937, 55: 407.—Fellows, C. G. Relaxing hyper- sesthetic rhinitis. Homoeop. Eye Ear Throat J., 1906, 12: 194.—Forman, J. Management of a case of pollen hay-fever with or without associated asthma. Ohio M. J., 1939, 35: 401-3.—Francis, C. A nasal treatment of hav fever. Prac- titioner, Lond., 1934, 132: 614-8.—Gay, L. N. Hay-fever; methods of treatment. West VirginiaM. J., 1934, 30:366-70.— Glas, E. Nasenschleimhautatzungen bei Heufieber. Wien. klin. Wschr., 1931, 44: 944. ------ Zur Therapie rhinogener Kopfschmerzen und vasomotorischen Schnupfens. Mschr. Ohrenh., 1935, 69: 1399. Also Wien. klin. Wschr., 1935, 48: 1287.------Zur Therapie der vasomotorischen Rhinitis und der rhinogenen Kopfschmerzen. Mschr. Ohrenh., 1936, 70: 151-4.—Goodman, A. A. Rationale of hay-fever treatment by modern methods. Collect. Papers N. York Homeop. M. Coll., 1935,1: 53-69.—Haiman, J. A. New aspects of the treatment of vasomotor rhinitis and other allergic con- ditions. Med. Rec, N. Y., 1934, 139: 541.—Hamm. Be- merkungen zur Heufieberbehandlung. Deut. med. Wschr., 1929, 55: 355.—Hay fever and the general practitioner. Bull. Lederle Lab., 1936, 4: 31-4.—Hinnant, I. M., & Evans, F. D. The treatment of hay fever in general practice. Med. Clin. N. America, 1935-36, 19: 1915-30.—Hirsch, O. Wie behandelt man Heuschnupfen? Wien. klin. Wschr., 1926, 39: 263.— Hollender, A. R. Cooperative management of aUergic rhinitis. J. Florida M. Ass., 1939-40, 26: 347-50. ------& Cottle. M. P/ „Su„rvey of Pr°gress in hay-fever and asthma therapy. Clin. M. & S., 1927, 34: 430-5.—Hollis, C. B. Suggestions for the therapeutic management of vasomotor rhinitis. Hahneman. Month., 1939, 74: 467-76—Jarvis, D. C. AppUed biochemistry in the etiology and treatment of seasonal hay fever. Tr. Am, Lar. Rhin. Otol. Soc, 1940, 46: 344-55. Also Laryngoscope, 1940, 50: 676-97.—Karrenberg, C. L. Kausalbehandlung des ausgebrochenen Heufiebers. Zschr. arztl. Fortbild., 1935, 32: 309-11. ------ Heufieberbehandlung im Anfallsstadium. Ther. Gegenwart, 1936, 77: 250-4.—Kehr. Die Praxis der Heufieberbehandlung. Deut. med. Wschr., 1934, 60: 824-8.— JMbnlV" & WaldaPfe>. K- Zur unspezifischen Behandlung der Rhinitis vasomotoria. Wien. med. Wschr., 931, 81: 1585.—Kristeller, W. Beitrag zur Heuschnupfenbehandlung. Deut. med. Wschr., 1926, 52: 1046—Lewy, A. Contribution t°>3e treatment of vasomotor rhinitis. Ann. Otol. Rhinol., 1937, 46: 827-34. Also Arch. Otolar., Chic, 1937, 25: 708 — Lichtenstein, M. R. The treatment of poUenosis in tuberculosis patients. Am. Rev. Tuberc, 1932, 26: 235-8.—McGrew, G. D. Time and money saved in the treatment of hay fever. Mil. Surgeon, 1937, 80: 371-4. Also repr.—Miller, C. D. Report on a method of treatment that offers a cure for hay fever. J. Am. Inst. Homeop., 1935, 28: 199; 1938, 31: 394.—Miiller- dos-Reis, W. Betrachtungen fiber die Behandlung der spasmodischen Rhinitis. Mschr. Ohrenh., 1939, 73: 101-7.— New treatment for hay fever. Nurs. Times, Lond., 1936, 32: 71,x: Portmann. Tratamiento del coriza espasm6dico. Dia med., B. Air., 1934-35, 7: 209.—Proetz, A. W. Treatment of the acute attack of allergic rhinitis. Tr. Am Lar Rhin Otol Soc,, 1936, 42:419-2L—Riegele. L. Unspezifische Behandlung HAY FEVER 119 HAY FEVER der Rhinitis vasomotorica. Zschr. Laryng., 1935, 26:148-51.— Scheffel, C. Some pharmacodynamic considerations in connec- tion with the locaUzed treatment of so-called hay fever. Dela- ware M. J., 1931, 3: 105-8.—Scheppegrell, W., & Thiberge, N. F. The treatment of hay fever and asthma. N. Orleans M. & S. J., 1928-29, 81: 337-42.—Schiff, N. S. The problems per- taining to the proper management of allergic phenomena, with special reference to non-specific therapy in bronchial asthma and hay fever. Ann. Clin. M., 1926-27, 5: 374-401.—Storm van Leeuwen, W. Die Therapie der allergischen Krankheiten. Fortsch. Ther., 1929, 5: 1; 41. ------ Die Behandlung des Heufiebers. Ther. Gegenwart, 1929, 70: 244-9.—Strebel, J. Zur symptomatischen Heufieberbehandlung. Klin. Mbl. Augenh., 1932, 89: 372-83. ------ Grundsatze und Ver- besserungen in der kausalen und symptomatischen Heufieber- behandlung oder Pollenallergose und der antiallergischen Therapie. Klin. Mbl. Augenh., 1935, 95: 525-36.—Tumarkin, A. Local treatment of vasomotor rhinorrhoea. Lancet, Lond., 1935, 2: 826.—Vistreich, F. The effect of intranasal phenol application in hay fever; quantitatively studied by a new in- tranasal swab test with pollen extracts. Laryngoscope, 1936, 46: 717-28.—Vollbracht, F. Ueber Heuschnupfentherapie. Wien. klin. Wschr., 1926, 39: 395-8.—Waldbott, G. L., & Ascher, M. S. Optimal doses in hay fever therapy. Tr. Am. Ther. Soc, 1937, 37: 69-72.—Zeller, M. The allergic manage- ment of vasomotor rhinitis. I'linois M. J., 1934, 66: 255-8. ---- Treatment: Physiotherapy. Bernheimer, L. B. Effects of irradiation on allergic nasal mucosa. Arch. Otolar., Chic, 1935, 22: 165-71. ------ & Cutler, M. Effects of radiation on allergic nasal mucosa. Ibid., 1932, 16: 561; 1933, 17: 658.—Billard, G. Considera- tions sur le pH des fleurs, le rhume des foins et les cures hydro- minerales. Paris med., 1927, 63: 283-8.—Cheval. Modifica- tion k ^instrumentation de MM. Lermoyez et Mahu, pour le traitement par Fair chaud des rhinites vaso-motrices. Bull. Soc. beige otol., 1902, 7: 64.—Claude, F. A propos du traite- ment du rhume et de 1'asthme des foins par la cure du Mont- Dore. Presse therm, dim., 1938, 79: 216-9.—Engel, R. Le traitement de la rhinite spasmodique par l'6manothSrapie avec le masque au thorium. Otorhinolar. internat., Lyon, 1934, 18: 337-42.—Fernandez Soto, E. El tratamiento del coriza espasm6dico; los resultados obtenidos por la ionizaci6n y radiumterapia intranasalis. Rev. med. cir. Habana, 1935, 40: 773783— Gottron, H., & Bode, H. G. Ueber endonasale QuarzUchtbehandlung des Heuschnupfens. Ther. Gegenwart, 1937, 78: 7-11.—Haag, F. E., & Schreus, H. Ueber die Rontgenbehandlung des Heufiebers. Strahlentherapie, 1931, 42: 485-91.—Hatchette, S. Roentgen ray treatment of hay fever. N. Orleans M. & S. J., 1936, 89: 70-3.—Hollender, A. R., & Cottle, M. H. Principles underlying the clinical applica- tion of physical agents in hay fever and asthma. Chicago M. Rec, 1926, 48: 215-8. Also Eye Ear &c Month., 1926-27, 5: 461-3.—Laquerriere. Ueber die Rontgenbehandlung des Heuschnupfens. Strahlentherapie, 1936, 57: 70-2— Millar, T. G. Observations on the treatment of hay fever by endonasal irradiation with ultra-violet light; report of 14 cases. Med. J. AustraUa, 1931, 2: 421.—Muck, O. Ueber den Einfluss heisser Fussbaderauf die Rhinitis vasomotoria (Beobachtungen durch den Adrenalinsondenversuch) Zschr. Hals &c Heilk., 1934-35, 37: 357-61.—Pokorny, L. Erfahrungen bei der Behandlung des Heuschnupfens und der Rhinitis vasomotoria. Strahlen- therapie, 1935, 52: 656-9. ------& Polorny, A. Die Rontgen- behandlung des Heuschnupfens. Ibid., 1928, 28: 808.— Salmony, A. Bestrahlungsapparat zur Heilungvon Heuschnu- pfen und Katarrhen der oberen Luftwege. Med. Welt, 1929, 3: 762.—Schreus, H. T. Weitere Ergebnisse der Rontgenbe- handlung des Heufiebers. Strahlentherapie, 1934,50:462-7.— Scott-Brown, W. G. The use of radium in aUergic rhinitis with polypi. Proc. R. Soc. M., Lond., 1937-38, 31: 655-9. ---- Treatment, surgical. Bisi, H. Las inyecciones de alcohol en el cornete inferior. en las rinitis espasm6dicas e hidrorrea nasal. Rev. espec, B. Air., 1931, 6: 229-39.—Byrd, H. Hay fever; its surgical con- quest. Laryngoscope, 1930, 40: 279-85.—Drennowa, K. A. Behandlung der vasomotorischen Rhinitis mit Injektion von physiologischer Losung in die Schleimhaut der unteren Nasen- muscheln. Arch. Ohr. &c. Heilk., 1931-32, 130: 235-44 — Hutter. Heilung eines FaUes von Rhinitis nervosa durch endonasale AlkohoUnjektion. Wien. med. Wschr., 1926, 76: 325.—Leichsenring. Behandlung allergischer Krankheiten mit Alkoholinjektion in die Nasenschleimhaut. Zschr. Hals &c Heilk., 1930-31, 28: 220-2.—Vail, H. H. Treatment of hay fever by nasal injections of alcohol. Arch. Otolar., Chic, 1933, 18:651-7. Also repr.—Walsh, T. E. Vasomotor rhinitis, its treatment by the injection of alcohol into the sphenopalatine ganglion. Ibid., 1932, 16: 83-8. Also repr.—Wassermann, M. Zur Therapie des Heuschnupfens und des vasomotorischen Schnupfens. Mschr. Ohrenh., 1930, 64: 576-9.—Weiss, L. Surgical aspects of hay fever. Eye Ear &c Month., 1933, 12: 332. ---- in children. Boudry, A. Le coryza spasmodique, amicrobien et vaso- moteur de l'enfant. J. med. Paris, 1939, 59: 368.—Fischer, L. Rhinitis in children, including recurrent coryza; due to intes- tinal autointoxication. N. York M. J., 1906, 84: 1216.— Haiman, J. A. Further studies of vaso-motor rhinitis in chil- dren. Arch. Pediat., N. Y., 1935, 52: 785-8.—Kahn, I. S. Essential differences in chronic pollen hay fever and asthma in children and in adults. J. Lab. Clin. M., 1926-27, 12: 1197-203. ------ Pollen toxemia in children. J. Am. M. Ass., 1927, 88: 241. Also Texas J. M., 1927-28, 23: 209-12.— Shick, B., & Peshkin, M. M. Hay fever. In Pract. Pediat. (Brennemann, J.) Hagerstown, 1937, 2: ch. 58, 14p. HAYGARTH, John, 1740-1827. Weaver, G. H. Clinician, investigator, apostle of sanita- tion. Bull. Soc. M. Hist. Chicago, 1928-30, 4: 156; 1933, 4: 264. HAYHOW, R. R. Feet in health and disease. 48p. illust. 12? Lond., J. Bale, Sons & Daniels- son, 1933. HAYHURST, Emery Roe, 1880- Per- sonal health, xi, 279p. 8? N. Y., McGraw- Hill Book Co., 1927. HAYLER, Emil, 1880- *Ascites oder Ovarialtumor nach Untersuchungen in der II. Universitatsklinik fiir Frauenkrankheiten und Geburtshilfe zu Munchen. 14p. 8? Miinch., J. Schreiber, 1933. HAYMAKER, Webb, 1902- See Bing, R. Textbook of nervous diseases; from the 5. German ed. 838p. 26cm. S. Louis, 1939.------ Com- pendium of regional diagnosis in lesions of the brain and spinal cord. 11. ed. 292p. 26cm. S. Louis, 1940. HAYMAN, Joseph Marchant, 1896- See Faddis, M. O., & Hayman, J. M. Textbook of pharma- cology for nurses. 418p. 21cm. Phila., 1940. HAYMANN, Hermann, 1879- Diffe- rentialdiagnostik in der Psychiatrie; mit einem Beitrag: Die diagnostische Bedeutung der In- telligenzpriifungen von Erich Stern, viii, 261p. 8? Dresd., T. Steinkopff, 1930. Forms v.3, Prakt. Differentialdiagn (G. Honigmann) Dresd., 1930. HAYMANN, Ludwig, 1877- Ueber Schussverletzungen des Ohres. vii, 200p. 8? Lpz., J. A. Barth, 1919. HAYN, Walter. Biochemischer Hausarzt; die Biochemie Dr med. Schiisslers. 290p. 16}£cm. Lpz., Hachmeister & Thai [1936] HAYNEL, Eric P[aul] R[ichard] 1906- *Zur Geschichte der medizinischen und mysti- schen Bedeutung des Allium victorialis (Aller- mannsharnisch) 28p. 8? Lpz., A. Edelmann, 1935. HAYNER, John Clifford, 1893- Regional anatomy adapted to dissection, xii, 687p. 8? Bait., W. Wood & Co., 1935. HAYNES, C. M. Elementary principles of electro-therapeutics for the use of physicians and students, vi, 51 lp. 8? Chic, Mcintosh Battery & Optical Co., 1890. HAYNES, Frederic. See Hartridge, Hamilton, & Haynes, F. Histology for medical students. 369 [30]p. 8? Lond., 1930. HAYNES, Gfeorge] S[ecretan] Notes on medical case-taking and the examination of patients, viii, 57p. 12? Cambr., W. Heffer & Sons, 1925. HAYNES, John Randolph, 1853- [Biography] California West. M., 1937, 47: 37, portr. HAYON, Moise, 1903- *L'ulcus pep- tique du jejunum. 105p. 8? Par., Jouve & cie, 1929. HAYOT, Charles, 1886- *La consangui- nite comparee chez I'homme et les animaux. 64p. 8? Par., A. Legrand, 1928. HAYS, Bernard W., 1867- President-elect, Missouri State Medical Association, 1937- 38. J. Missouri M. Ass., 1937, 34: 204, portr. HAYS, Harold Melvin, 1880-1940. Per- sonality and other things (a semi-autobiography) ix, 163p. portr. 8? N. Y., Am. Physician, Inc. [1937] HAYS 120 HAZLITT See also Brickner, Walter M., & Hays, H. M. Seven hundred surgical suggestions. 150p. 12? N. Y., 1909. For biography see J. Am. M. Ass., 1940, 115: 1115. HAYS, Isaac, 1796-1879. Flaxman, N. Pioneer American ophthalmologist. Arch. Ophth., Chic, 1936, 16: 78-90.—Portrait. Hebrew M. J., NT Y., 1938, 2: 196.—Portrait, photograph. See collection in library. HAYS, Samuel. An outline of statistics. vii, 215p. tab. ch. 8? Lond., Longmans, Green & Co. [1937] HAY Sais, Edouard, 1915- *Le traite- ment de l'endometriose genitale; ses resultats. 105p. 25}'cm. Lyon, Bose freres, 1939. HAYT, Emanuel, & HAYT, Lillian R. Legal guide for American hospitals. xxviii, 608p. 231 cm. N. Y., Hosp. Textb. Co., 1940. HAYT, Lillian R. Pee Hayt. E., & Hayt, L. R. Legal guide for American hospitals. 608p. 23Hcm. N. Y., 1940. HAYTER, N. M. Counting the calories. p. 1. 58p. 16? [Los Ang.] Montross Found. [1933] HAYTHORN Samuel Reese, 1880- Wil- liam H. Singer Memorial Research Laboratory: brief history and description. 16p. illust. pl. 8? Pittsb., Pa. [n. pub.J 1917. — COHEN, Mortimer, & PERMAR, How- ard Henry. Outline of autopsy technic. 34 [6]p. illust. 8? Pittsb., Pa., Univ. Pittsburgh School M., 1933. HAYWARD, John A. The romance of medi- cine, xviii, 278p. illust. tab. 8? Lond., G. Routledge & Sons [1937] HAYWARD, William Thornborough, 1854- 1928. Obituary. Brit. M. J., 1929, 1: 47; 274. HAYWARDS Heath, Eng. Brighton County Borough Asylum. (Name changed in 1920 to Brighton County Borough Mental Hospital) Annual report. Haywards Heath, 1.-7., 1904-10, 8.-9., 1911-12; 11., 1914; 15., 1918; 17.-22., 1920—25. HAYWARDS Heath, Eng. East Sussex County Lunatic Asylum. Annual report. Hay- wards Heath, 1.-10., 1859-68; 14., 1872; 12., 1870; 15.-16., 1873-74; 19.-27., 1877-85; 28.-44., 1886-1902. HAZARD, Rene. Applications medicales du nouveau codex, et prescription des substances veneneuses. 95p. tab. 19}£cm. Par., Masson & cie, 1939. See also Richaud, A., & Hazard, R. Precis de therapeutique et de pharmacologie. 7. ed. 1257p.; 69p. 2 pts. 20cm. Par., 1935. HAZEBROUCK, Gabriel, 1914- Con- tribution au diagnostic du cancer du corps de l'uterus par 1'hysterographie. 64p. 24cm. Par., G. Dalex, 1939. HAZELDINE, Norton F. W. Therapeutic dietetics or the science of health foods and their medicine values. 2. ed. 68p. 12? Los Ang., Kingsley, Moles & Collins Co. [1908] HAZELWOOD, Ky. Association Sanatorium [1907] Reports of officers. Hazelwood, 1908-10. HAZEN, Elizabeth Lee, 1888- *General and local immunity to ricin [Columbia Univ.] p.171-218. 8? X. Y. [n. pub.] 1927. HAZEN, Henry Honeyman, 1879- Cu- taneous X-rav and radium therapy. 166p. 8° S. Louis, C. V. Mosby Co., 1931. HAZIN, Samuel, 1911- *Angor syncopal a repetition. 88p. 24cm. Par., J. Haumont. 1939. HAZLETT, Leslie Ramsey, 1868-1938. Obituary. Tr. Am. Acad. Ophth. Otolar., 1939, 414. HAZLITT, Victoria, 1SS7 1932. Ability, a psychological study, ix, 147p. 2 pl. 8? Lond., Methuen & Co. [1926] —— The psychology of infancy, ix, 149p. 8? Lond., Methuen & Co. [1933] For biography see Brit. J. Psychol., 1932, 23: 205-8, portr, HAZZARD, Charles. Lectures on principles of osteopathy. 209p. 8? Kirksville, Mo., Advocate Book & Job Print., 1898. ---- Principles of osteopathy. 2. ed. lOlp. 4? Kirksville, Advocate Print. Co., 1898. HEAD, Sir Henry, 1861-1640. Aphasia and kindred disorders of speech. 2v. xiv, 549p.; xxxiii, 430p. 4? Cambr., Univ. Press, 1926. For biography see Arch. Neur. Psychiat., Chic, 1941, 45: 698-702. Also Brain, Lond., 1940, 63: 205-8. Also Brit. M. J., 1940, 2: 539-41, portr. Also J. Nerv. Ment. Dis., 1941, 93: 276. Also Lancet, Lond., 1940, 2: 534, portr. HEAD, Louis R., 1862-1933. [Obituary] Wisconsin M. J., 1933, 32: 486. HEAD. See also Brain; Cranium; Face; Head and neck; Head injury; Scalp; also names of bones, cavities, muscles, nerves, and other parts of the head as Ear; Eye; Frontal bone; Jaw; Naso- lacrimal duct; Nose; Palate, &c. Atjer, K. Atlas der Anatomie des Kopfes; mit einem Anhang iiber Brust- und Bauchhohle. 2. Aufl. 267p. 4? Miinch. [1935] Smith, H. J. Smith's compend of anatomy of the head, with special reference to the skin and its appendages. 38p. 8? N. Y. [1931] Bean, B., Jk Speidel, C. C. A note on the head form of 435 American soli tiers, with special reference to flattening in the occipital K^ion. Anat. Rec, 1923, 25: 301-11—Desfosses, P. Les formes generales de la teLe. Presse mid., 1933, 41:493-6.— Dijkstra, O. H. [Contribution to the physical anatomy of the cranium and brain] Geneesk. bl., 1926-27, 25: 171-210, 4 ch.— Egehoj, J. Das Lymphgefassystem des Kopfes beim Rinde. Deut. tierarztl. Wschr., 1934, 42: 333-6.—Frazier, C. H. The comparative anatomy of the afferent system of the head. Tr. Am. Neur. Ass., 1929, 55: 1-12. Also Arch. Neur. Psychiat., Chic, 1929, 22: 1105-15. Also repr.—Histoire (L') de la tete humaine. Anthropologic, Par., 1934-35, 44: 93-120.—Knese, K. H. Das Kopfgelenk der aquatilen Saugetiere. Morph. Jahrb., 1936, 78: 314-76.—Larsell, O. The sympathetics of the head. West. J. Surg., 1938, 46: 633-8.—Malis.S. Ananatomic crown as an aid for postgraduate study of the anatomy of the head. Ann. Otol. Rhinol., 1940, 49: 239-47.—Pasteur, F. Morphologie de la tete. Bull. Acad, med., Par., 1940, 3. ser., 123: 247-54.—Vallcis, H. V. La sustentation de la tete et le ligament cervical posteLicur chez I'homme et les anthropoides. Anthropologic, Par., 1926, 36: 191-207.—Vitushinsky, V. I. [Method of dissecting the face and visceral cranium] Arkh. pat. anat., Moskva, 1940, 6: No. 3, 141-5. ---- Abnormity. See also Abnormities, double: Dicephalus; Acephalus; Anencephalus; Cyclocephalus; Hy- drocephalus; Microcephalus; Otocephalus; Oxy- cephalus, &c. Refait, R. M. *Contribution a l'etude des janicephales; le Dieu Janus dans la legende, la numismatique, la litt6rature et les arts. 113p. 8? Lyon, 1935. Aloi. Contributo alio studio d'una rara malformazione della testa. Arch, ortop., Milano, 1934, 50: 1223-30.—Big head. Science News Lett., 1937, 31: 35.—Debr6, R., Lamy, M. [et al.] Maladie hemolytique chez 2 jumeaux avec des deformations cranio-faciale et Unguale. Bull. Acad. med. hop. Paris, 1937, 3. ser., 53: 1465-72.—Greene, D. Asymmetry of the head and face in infants and in children. Am. J. Dis. Child., 1931, 41: 1317-26.—Hippias, A. [Monstrosity of the head] Vrach. gaz., 1909, 16: 824.—Hirsh, J. An introduction to teratology; mal- formations of the head and jaws. Arch. Clin. Oral Path., 1938, 2: 262-87.—Lim, K. T. On foetuses with cephalic malforma- tions, delivered in the Peiping Union Medical CoUege Hospital from July 1st 1922-Jan. 1st 1934. Chin. M. J., 1935, 49: 624- 35, 6 pl.—Oschanitzky, L. Zungen- und Kieferform bei Hirn- und Scht.delmissbildungen. Beitr. path. Anat., 1935, 95: 238.— Reilcs, M. Un cas de malformations congenitales cephaliques multiples dun nouveau-n6. Bull. Soc. obst. gyn Paris 1933, 22: 234-6. Also Strasbourg med., 1933, 93: 261.—Rizzatti, E. Le malformazioni congenite deU'estremo cefalico. Riv. ital. HEAD 121 HEAD gin., 1927, 6: 517-634.—Robin, V., & Bresso, C. Anomalie de disposition de la teLe chez un veau. Rev. vet., Toulouse, 1920, 72: 161-9.—Salen. Presentation d'un nourrisson atteint de deformations de la tfite et des membres. Marseille mid., 1923, 60: 1200.—Simons, S. [A rare case of congenital deformities (deformed head and other abnormities)] Ned. tjschr. geneesk., 1927, 71: pt 2, 1000-2, 2 pl.—Vitu, P., & Houdiniere, A. Vari^te opocephale chez l'agneau; varieLe 6docephale chez le porcelet. Rec. med. vet., 1934, 110: 398-409.—Zinram, K. Ueber Verbiegungen der Nasenscheidewand bei mopskopfigen Hunden; ein Beitrag zur Frage der Mopskopfigkeit und der Aetiologie der Deviatio septi. Zschr. ges. Anat., 1. Abt., 1932- 33, 99: 632-45. ---- Blood vessels [and diseases] See also Aneurysm; Angiomatosis; also names of arteries and veins of the head as Carotid artery; Jugular vein, &c. Hughes, A. F. W. On the development of the blood vessels in the head of the chick, p.75-130. 29cm. Lond., 1934. Jtjncker, E. [L. H.] *Aneurysma verum et spurium des Kopfes und Halses. 15p. 8? Kiel, 1932. Krause, G. *Beitrag zur Klinik des Angioma racemosum [Berlin] 24p. 8? Charlottenb., 1934. Schmitt, O. *Beitrag zur Klinik und chirur- gischen Behandlung des Angioma arteriale racemosum, besonders des Kopfes [Frankfurt] 39p. 8? Tub., 1919. Also Beitr. kUn. Chir., 118: 178-215. Wolff, F. *Ueber Haemangiome des Kopfes. 24p. 8? Kiel, 1931. Grahe & Metzger. Regionare Gefassreaktionen am Kopfe auf Haut- und Schleimhautreize und ihre kUnische Bedeutung. Zschr. Laryng., 1926-27, 15: 171-3.—Haenel, H. Ein Fall von Aneurysma racemosum des Kopfes. Med. KUn., Berl., 1926, 22: 1762.—Jona, G. Turbe circolatorie del capo, accessionali, extra-apoplettiche. Policlinico, 1936, 43: sez. prat., 1899-913. ----- Turbe circolatorie del capo, accessionali; crisi angio- spastiche oculari. Ibid., 2207-16.—Lalvani, P. P. Electro- coagulation fsurgical diathermy) in multiple angiomata of the head. Ind. M. Gaz., 1929, 64: 387.—Noordenbos, W., & de Josselin de Jong, R. Aneurysma arteriale racemosum van het hoofd. Ned. tschr. geneesk., 1918, 2: 1224-35, pl.—Shilovtsev, S. P. [Operative treatment of extensive angiomas of the head] Vest, khir., 1936, 45: 236-9. Also Arch. klin. Chir., 1935-36, 184: 179-82. ---- Cancer. Galloway, T. C. Surgical diathermy in carcinomas about the head. Illinois M. J., 1930, 57: 198-200. ------ MaUgnaricy about the head; radiation or electrosurgery? Arch. Phys. Ther., 1934, 15: 343-6. ------ The selective treatment of malig- nancy about the head. Tr. Am. Laryng. Ass., 1935, 41: 395- 405. Also Ann. Otol. Rhinol., 1935, 44:450-7. ------ Team work in head cancer. IUinois M. J., 1935, 68: 331-6.—Pollock. H. L. Primary and metastatic cancer of the head. J.Michigan M. Soc, 1926, 25: 131-4.—Rhinehart. D. A., & Rhinehart, B. A. Protracted Roentgen therapv of malignancies, particularly of the head and face. South. M. J., 1941, 34: 820-3.—Vrijrran. L. H. [Carcinoma basocellulare capitis] Ned. tschr. geneesk.. 1935,79: 5368.—Weissenbach, R. J., Basch, G. [et al.] Tumeurs metastasiques de la peau du front, des tempes et du crAne (r^ticulo-sarcome ou epithelioma) Bull. Soc. fr. derm, syph., 1933, 40: 1448-57.—Wyeth, G. A. MaUgnant tumors of head. Am. J. Surg., 1937, 36: 63-8. ---- Development and growth. Frets, G. P. Heredity of headform in man. 193p. 8? The Hague. 1921. Kretschmar, G. *Untersuchungen iiber das Wachstum des Kopfes mit einer Bemerkung iiber Rasseneigentiimlickheit und besondere Begabung zu gymnastischen Uebungen. p.473-83. 8? Lpz., 1931. Also Zschr. ges. Anat., 2. Abt., 1931-32, 16: Abel, W. Die Vererbung von Antlitz und Kopfform des Menschen. Zschr. Morph. Anthrop., 1934, 33: 261-45. 2 pl — Adelmann, H. B. The development of the premandibular head cavities and the relations of the anterior end of the notochord in the chick and robin. J. Morph., 1926-27, 42: 371-427, 6 pl — Allis, E. P.. jr. Concerning the development of the prechordal portion of the vertebrate head. J. Anat., Lond., 1937-38, 72: 584-607.—Brodie, A. G. On the growth pattern of the human head; from the 3rd month to the 8th year of life. Am. J. Anat., 1941, 68: 209-62.—Davenport, C. B. Post-natal development of the head. Proc. Am. Philos. Soc, 1940, 83: 1-215 6 r>l Also repr. Also Sc Month., 1941, 52: 197-202.—Desai've, I\ Recherches sur 1 evolution du mesoblaste cephalique preotique de Scylhum camcula. Arch, biol., Liege, 1932 43-29-92 5 pl.—Godin P. Heredity de l'indice cephalique; l'indice cephali- queduproduide premiere generation d'un croisement humain est 70 fois sur 100 celui de la mere. Strasbourg med., 1931 91: 651.—Goldbv, F On the presence of a series of ectodermal placodes in the head region of a sparrow embryo. J. Anat Lond .1927-28, 62: 135-8.-GIees, P. The differentiation of tne bram and other tissues in an implanted portion of an embryonic head. Ibid., 1940-41, 75: 239-47, pl.—Goldstein, {?• S- Development of the head in the same individuals. Human Biol., 1939, 11: 197-219—Gregory, W. K The palaeomorphology of the human head; 10 structural stages from fash to man. Bull. N. York Acad. M., 1927, n. ser., 3: 525-7 — Grosser, O. Primitivstreifen und Kopffortsatz beim Menschen. Verh. Anat. Ges., 1931, 39: 135-9. ------ Der Kopffortsatz des Pnmitivstreifens beim Menschen; seine Differenzierung bei oS?xSmbJ7° Wa 17- Zschr- «es- Anat- !• Abt- 1931, 94: 275-92— Guggenheim, L. K. PreUminarv report of a method of studying the development of the ear, the paranasal sinuses, and the various centres of ossification in the head. Laryngo- scope, 1931, 41: 232-6—Hatschek, B. Studien zur Segment- theone des Wirbeltierkopfes; uber die Mesodermsegmente der zwei Kopfregionen bei Petromyzon fluviatilis. Morph. Jahrb., 1929, 61: 255-303, 8 pl.—Hill, J. P., & Florian, J. The develop- ment of head-process and prechordal plate in man. J. Anat., Lond., 1930-31, 65: 242-6—Hrdlicka, A. Growth of the head during adult life; further evidence. Am. J. Phys. Anthrop 1938-39,24:127-59. Also repr.—Hunter. R. M. Thedevelop- ment of the anterior post-otic somites in the rabbit. J. Morph., 1935, 57: 501-31.—Jager, J. Ueber die Segmentierung der Hinterhauptregion und die Beziehung der Cartilago acrochor- dalis zur Mesodermcommissur (eine Untersuchung an Vogeln) Morph. Jahrb., 1926, 56: 1-21, 3 pl.—Jolly, J., & Ferester, M. L'evolution du prolongement cephalique dans l'oeuf du rat. C. rend. Soc biol., 1935, 118: 1282-4.—Jonata, R. Ricerche radiografiche sulla ossificazione della testa nei feto umano. Ann radiol., Bologna, 1936, 10: 289-314.—Keibel [Entwicklungs- geschichte des Kopfesl Verh. Anat. Ges., 1925, 34: 4-21.— Keiter, F. Ueber die Formentwicklung des kindlichen Kopfes und Gesichtes. Zschr. ges. Anat., 2. Abt., 1932-33, 17: 345- 83. —Kingsbury, B. F. Branchiomerism and the theory of head segmentation. J. Morph., 1926-27, 42: 83-109.— Kopsch, F. Die Lage des Materials fur Kopf, Primitivstreifen und Gefasshof in der Keimscheibe des unbebriiteten Hiihnereies und seine Entwicklung wahrend der ersten beiden Tage der Bebriitung. Zschr. mikr. anat. Forsch., 1934, 35: 254-330.— Krohn, F. Futterungsversuche an Tritonen: die Veranderung der Kopfform des TeicLmolches (M. vulgaris [Taeniata]) infolge Muschelfleischfutterung. Arch. Entwmech., 1930, 121: 545- 97.—Lange, D. de. The head problem in chordates. J. Anat., Lond., 1935-36, 70: 515-47.—Mangold, O. Isolationsversuche zur Analyse der Entwicklung bestimmter Kopforgane. Natur- wissenschaften, 1933, 21: 394-7.—Nissen, W. Der Kopf des Kindes in seiner Entwicklung wahrend des Wachstumsund die Konstitution des Kindes. Zschr. ges. Anat., 2. Abt., 1931-32, 16: 537-58.—Shilova, A. V. [Shape of head and growth during fetal life] Antrop. J., Moskva, 1937, 3-25.—Starck, D. Ueber einige EntwicklungsvorgSnge am Kopf der Urodelen. Morph. Jahrb., 1937, 79: 358-435.—Stone, L. S. Experiments show- ing the role of migrating neural crest (mesectoderm) in the formation of head skeleton and loose connective tissue in Rana Dalustris. Arch. Entwmeeh., 1929, 118: 40-77.—Veit, O. Beitrage zur Kenntnis des Kopfes der Wirbeltiere; Beobach- tungen zur Fruhentwicklung des Kopfes von Petromyzon planeri. Morph. Jahrb., 1939, 84: 86-107—Vilae. E. Ueber die Form und das Wachstum des Kopfes menschlicher Feten. Zschr. ges. Anat., 1. Abt., 1929, 90: 694-712.—Wissler, C. Pace and sex differences in growth of head form. Eugen. News, 1927, 12: 81-3. ---- Disease. Auvhay, M. Maladies du crane et de I'ence1- phale. 3. ed. 864p. 8? Par., 1931. Cauhe>e\ J. *Contribution a l'etude des phlegmons diffus cephaliques (phlegmons du plancher de la bouche excepted) 98p. 8? Par., 1933. Neidhard, C. Pathogenetic and clinical repertory of the most prominent symptoms of the head, with their concomitants and conditions. 188p. 8? Phila., 1888. Barber, H. W. Aetiology and treatment of some common diseases of the face and scalp. Guy's Hosp. Gaz., Lond., 1939, 53: 382; 397.—Baseoe, P. The auriculotemporal syndrome and other vasomotor disturbances about the head. Med. Clin. N. America, 1932, 16: 405.—Bustos & Cornejo Saravia. Consideraciones diagnosticas y terapeuticas sobre actino- micosis temporo-maxilar. Bol. Acad, argent, cir., 1941, 25: 693-700.—Church, R. E. Infections of head. Am. J. Surg., 1937, 36: 57-62.—Davis, J. W. Comparative study of some patient's heads; preliminary report, at the Anna State Hospital. Illinois M. J., 1939, 75: 372—Eagleton, W. P. Traumatic HEAD 122 HEAD and infective lesions of the head, the chief manifestations of which are visual disturbances; their diagnosis and surgical treatment. Surg. Clin. N. America, 1926, 6: 1435-52.— Gonzalez Suarez. Gangrena simetrica de la cara y sus factored patogenos. Med. ibera, 1934, 28: pt 2, 721-3.—Harrburjrer, L. P. Head murmurs. Am. J. M. Sc, 1931, 181: 750-S — Kamman, G. R. Some painful conditions about the head and face. J. Lancet, 1940, 60: 111-4.—Komendantov, L. E. [Significance of the cranial segment in the pathology of the constitution] Vest, otorinolar., 1938, 506-9.—Smith, C. E., & Bruns, ( . H. Head treating device. U. S. Patent Off., 1939, No. 2,171,376. ---- Injury. See as main heading Head injury. ---- Isolation and transplantation. Heymans, J. F., & Heymans, C. Perfusion des isolierten Kopfes vom isolierten Herz- Lungen-Praparat aus beim selben Hund. p.1081-3. Berl., 1932. ---- Verfahren, um den isolierten Hundekopf durch Anastomose mit dem Blutkreislauf eines anderen Hundes iiberlebend zu halten. p. 1075- 79. Berl., 1932. Artom, C. Un preparato di testa isolata per dimostrazioni didattiche e ricerche sperimentali. Boll. Soc. ital. biol. sper., 1928, 3: 471-4. ------ & Pasqualino, G. Sui movimenti respiratori concomitanti nella testa isolata di cane (nota preventiva) Ibid., 475-7.-—Binet, I.. La tete isolee; le systSme ciiur-crosse-aortique, zone r£flexosi('ne intervenant dans la regulation de la respiration. Presse med., 1928, 36: 723-6.— Urjuchenenko, S. Der lebende, korperlose Hundekopf. rinschau, 1929, 33: 50. ■------ & Tchetchuline, S. Experi- ences avec la tete isol6e du chien; technique et conditions des experiences. J. physiol. path. g§n., 1929, 27: 31-45 Experiences avec la tete isolee du chien; resultats des experi- ences. Ibid., 64-79.—Fredericq, L. Mouvements rythmSs de la tete isolee de la tortue terrestre. Arch, internat. physiol., Liege, 1926, 27: 112.—Heymann, K. Der Kampf mit dem Tode. Med. Welt, 1929, 3: 267.—Heymans, J. F., & Heymans, C. Recherches physiologiques et pharmacodynamiques sur la tete isolee du chien: sur l'influence respiratoire et pneumo- gastrique de l'adrenaline, de l'atropine, de la pituitrine, de la nicotine et des digitaliques. Arch, internat. pharm. dyn., Par., 1926, 32: 9-41.—Hirsch, S. La tc'te isolee. Umschau, 1929, 33: 48-50.—Houssay, B. A. I .a vida de la cabeza aislada: estudios sobre la cabeza v el tronco decapitados. Rev. As. med. argent., 1928, 41: 641-706. Also Dfa med., B. Air., 1928-29, 1: 2; 10; 18.—Malabotti, A. Verwandlung von Insi'kten (Tenebrio molitor L., Vanessa io L. und Vanessa urticae L., Dixippus morosus Br. et Redt.) mit replantierten Kopfen. Riv. biol., 1938, 26: 31-80.—Nowak, S. J. G., & Samaan, A. Technique de perfusion de la tete isolee, unique- ment reliee k son tronc par la moelle et les nerfs vagues. C. rend. Soc. biol., 1934, 115: 184-7.—Rostand, J. Essais de greffe cephalique chez Carausius morosus. Ibid., 1926, 95: 948-50.—Somer, E. de. Sur la priorite de la decouverte de la technique de l'isolement de la tete des animaux a sang chaud. J. physiol. path, gen., 1935, 33: 1145-8.—Tournade, A.. Malmejac, J., & Rocchisani, L. lechnique de la tete irriguee. C. rend. Soc biol., 1934, 115: 1042-4. ---- Measurement. See also Anthropometry; Cranium, Cephalic index; Criminology, &c. Goldstein, M. S. Measurement of height of head in the living. Am. J. Phys. Anthrop., 1937-38, 23: 341-54.—Gunther, H. Die klinische Bedeutung der relativen Kopfhohe. Endo- krinologie, 1938, 20: 10-23. ------ Der Liingenumfangs- index des Kopfes. Ibid., 344-55.—Pickering,- S. P. Correla- tion of brain and head measurements, and relation of brain Bhape and size to shape and size of the head. Am. J. Phys Anthrop., 1930-31, 15: 1-52.—Thcms, H., & Godfried M. S. The suboccipitobregmatic circumference. Am. J. Obst. 1940 39: 841-3. ---- Movements and attitude. See also Atlas and epistropheus, Joints; Audition; Vision; also such headings as Spasm; Torticollis, &c. Brain. W. R. On the rotated or cerebeUar posture of the head. Brain, Lond., 1926, 49: 61-76.—Girard, L. L'attitude normale de la tete determinee par le labyrinthe de l'oreille Otorhinolar. internat., Lyon, 1930, 14: 517-37.—McNallyj W. J. Recent physiological facts concerning the rotated or cerebeUar posture of the head. Tr. Am. Lar. Rhin Otol Soc 1928, 34: 246-51. Also J. Lar. Otol., Lond., 1928, 43:484-9.— Rogier, H. Le pronostic des tetes baUantes cl.< z les nourris- sons. Arch. med. enf., 1928, 31: 538-46.—Scheins-Hennebert, R., & Scheins-Hennebert, P. Contribution k l'etude des rnouvements angulaires habituels de la tete. C. rend. Soc. biol., 1933, 113: 1523-5.—Schwarz. A. M. Kopfhaltung und Kiefer. Zschr. Stomat., 1926, 24: 669-744.—Wallisch. W. Kopfhaltung und Kiefer. Ibid., 890. ---- Muscles. See also Mastication; Mouth, &c. Ltjbosch, W. Muskeln des Kopfes; viscerale Muskulatur (Fortsetzung) p. 1011-106. 26)^>cm. Berl., 1938. Ltjther, A., & Ltjbosch, W. Muskeln des Kopfes; viscerale Muskulatur. p.467-542. 26Hcm. Berl., 1938. Edgeworth, F. H. On the masticatory and hyoid muscles of larvae of Xenopus laevis. J. Anat., Lond., 1929-30, 64: 184-8.—Hovelacque, A. Connexions du muscle temporal et du muscle buccinateur; rapports du nerf buccal. Bibliogr. anat., Par., 1914, 24: 15-20.—Nishi, S. Muskeln des Kopfes, parie- tale Muskulatur. In Handb. vergl. Anat. Wirbeltiere (L, Bolk, et al.) Berl., 1938, 5: 447-66.—Piatt, J. Morphogenesis of the cranial muscles of Amblvstoma punctatum. J. Morph., 1938, 63: 513-87, 8 pl.—TretjakofT, D. Das Skelett und die Muskulatur im Kopfe des Flussneunauges. Zschr. wiss. Zool., 1926, 128: 267-304. ---- Radiography. Goldhamer, K. Normale Anatomie des Kopfes im Rontgenbild. 2 pts. Uebersetzt von Steinhaus. 115p.; 44p. fol. Lpz., 1930, 1931. Chiara, G., Caponnetto, A., & Nicotra, A. Tentativi di visualizzazione radiografica delle vie linfatiche tra i seni frontaliele meningi. Radiol, med., Milano, 1935, 22: 1092-6.— CIaoue\ C, fils. Contribution k la technique de l'examen radiographique de la tete. J. m6d. Bordeaux, 1928, 58: 708- 10.—Egas Moniz, Alves, A., & Pereira Caldas. Interpretacao das opacidades nas series angiograficas da cabeca. Lisboa med., 1933, 10: 122-43.—Egas Moniz, Almedia Lima & Pereira Caldas. Angiographies en sfirie de la circulation de la tete. Rev. neur., Par., 1934, 41: 489-510—Jacobi, W. Stu- dien zur rontgenographischen Darstellung der Kopfarterien des lebenden Hundes. Arch. Psychiat., Berl., 1928-29, 86: 240-8.—Kern, M. J. Complete Roentgenological study of the head. Am. J. Roentg., 1926, n. ser., 16: 264.—Mahoney, H. O. Radiography of the head and sinuses. In X-Rav studies (Gen. Electr. X-Ray Corp.) Chic, 1935, 54-61 — Manges, W. F. Apparatus for making roentgehographic examinations of the head. Am. J. Roentg., 1928, 19: 166-9.— Moniz, E., & Furtado, D. Visibility aux rayons X des veines temporale superficielle et occipitale. Fol. anat. Univ. Conimbr., 1933, 8: No. 5, 1, 2 pl.—Postero-anterior projection of head (adult) technical considerations. Radiogi. Clin. Photdfe*;, 1931, 7: 8.—Radiography of the head. Ibid., 2; 6.—Radio- graphic head survey. Ibid., 2-5.—Saves. Radiographic de la tete par rayon horizontal. J. radiol. electr., 1937, 21: 289-93.— Wahl, F. A. Die Konfiguration des kindlichen Kopfes und ihre differentialdiagnostischen Schwierigkeiten im Rontgenbild. Zbl. Gyn., 1931, 55: 2594-8.—Whitmore, W. H. The occipital view: modified technique. Am. J. Roentg., 1934, 31: 271. ---- Sarcoma. Rossmann, J. *Ein Fall von Melanosarcom. 34p. 8? Lpz., 1898. Ardoin, G. Sarcome rhabdomyoblastique de la region temporo-occipitale. Bull. Ass. fr. cancer, 1929, 18: 255-68.— Bardisian, A. Tumori maligni ed eosinofilia; raro sarcoma della testa. Riv. clin. pediat., 1930, 28: 802-8, 2 pl.—Mitro- fanov, P. P. [Organoid teratoma of the temporal region] Vest, khir., 1936, 45: 232. ---- Surgery. See also Decapitation; Neurosurgery; Ophthal- mology; Otology; Rhinology; Surgery, plastic, &c; also Head injury. Coenen, IL, Krause, F. [et al.] Chirurgie des Kopfes. 6. Aufl. 1394p. 8? Stuttg., 1926. Schmieden, V., & Peiper, H. Operationen am Kopfe. 87p. 8? Jena, 1932. Wakeley, C. P. G. Head, spinal column, and salivary glands, p.1747-1880. 8? N. Y., 1936. In Postgrad. Surg. (Maingot, R.) 2: Beck, J. C. Plastic and reconstructive surgery about the race and head; then and now. Illinois Al. J., 1939 76-237-42 — Brewster. W. R Mode of closure and dressing of wounds, especially those of the head. J. Am. M. Ass., 1928 90- 692 — Buchanan, T. D A method of anesthesia for operations about the head In Fifth Aven. Hosp. Clin., N. Y., 1927, 185-9 — ^?™~ h vf°,rISit1!8 ^f &e car and no8e treated by plastic urgery. N. York State J. M., 1939, 39: 1956-61.-Davis, A. 1 ir 1Q9Q Tn^y*iLtLe,?ar' n0b<' and face- Ar<=h- Otolar., HEAD 123 HEADACHE 3.—Dylewski. B. Ein Apparat zur Haltung und Fixierung des Kopfes der Patienten wahrend Operationen am Kopfe. Mschr. Ohrenh., 1929, 63: 511-5.—Figi, F. A. Plastic repair following removal of neoplasms about the head. Nebraska M. J., 1940, 25: 165-71. Also Collect. Papers Mayo Clin., 1938, 30: 692- 6.—Fruehwald.V. Progress in plastic surgery of the nose and ears. Rev. chir. plast., Brux., 1933-34, 3: 155-67.—Gatewood. Plastics of the face and jaw. Surg. Clin. N. America, 1927, 7: 539-49.—Groff, R. A. Surgery of the head. In Cyclop. Med. (Piersol-Bortz) Phila., 1939, 7: 56-71.—Jenkins, H. P. Plastic surgery of the head and face. Surg. Clin. N. America, 1941, 21: 37-53.—Jones, J. G. A new head band. Arch. Otolar., Chic, 1936, 23: 592.—Lederer, F. L. Prosthetic aids in reconstructive surgery about the head; presentation of a new method. Ibid., 1928, 8: 531-54.—Mandl, R. Einige praktische Griffe und Kniffe zur konservativen Heilung der chronischen Mittelohr- und Nasennebenhohlen-Erkrankungen. Med. Klin., Berl., 1926, 22: 1686.—P., H. C. Head and face surgerv units. Am. J. Orthodont., 1940, 26: 819.—Perthes, G. Ueber Rhino- plastik mittels Visierlappen und iiber Stomatoplastik aud der Kopfhaut. Arch. klin. Chir., 1926, 142: 572-89 [Discussion] 129.—Phillips, G. A new method of head-fixation for opera- tions in the sitting position. Austral. N. Zealand J. Surg., 1937, 7: 67-9.—Poppen, J. L. A modified coronal incision. Ann. Surg., 1935, 102: 317-9. Also repr.—Rebelo Neto. J. Pro- gresses da cirurgia plastica da cabeca e do pesooco atravez a bibliografia de 1939. Rev. brasil. otorinolar., 1940, 8: 111-20.— Ross, M. A. Anesthesia in the head specialties as given at the University of Iowa. Current Res. Anesth., 1927, 6: 46-50.— Rowntree, C. Operative surgery of the aged. Clin. J., Lond., 1931,60:257-61. ---- Tumor. See also subheadings Cancer; Sarcoma. Diss, A., & Prieto, J. G. PapiUomes multiples des commis- sures labiales et de la langue et papiUome de la joue droite developpS sur une tache de kfiratose senile. Bull. Soc. fr. derm, syph., 1926, 33: 583.—Eden, K. C. The benign fibro- osseous tumours of the skuU and facial bones. Brit. J. Surg., 1939-40, 27: 323-50.—Jadassohn. Psammome und Neurinome am Hinterkopf. Schweiz. med. Wschr., 1927, 57: 42.—Rathcke, L. Teratoide Geschwulst am kindlichen Kopf. Beitr. kUn. Chir., 1938, 168: 610-5.—Sington, H. S. Tumour of fcetal head. Proc R. Soc. M., Lond., 1907-8, 1: Obst. Gyn. Sect., 158-60.—Stannus, H. S. A case of teratoma of the foetal head. Tr. Obst. Soc London (1902) 1903, 44: 78-90, 2 1., 2 pl.— Stepien, B. Tumeur de la region zygomato-temporale (kyste- dermoide?) communiquant avec la cavite cranienne. Rev. neur., Par., 1936, 65: 839. ---- in animals. Beccari, N. Osservaziuiri suUa struttura della testa nella lieve dupUcita, anteriore di un avanotto di trota. Arch. ital. anat., 1934, 33: 14-37, pl.—Eales, N. B. The anatomy of the head of a foetal African elephant, Elephas africanus (Loxodonta africana) Proc. R. Soc. Edinburgh, 1925-26, 54: 491-551, 12 pl. Also Anat. Anz., 1926, 61: 361-4.—Fleischmann, A. Die Kopfgegend der Nabeltiere (Amniota) Zschr. ges. Anat., 1. Abt., 1932, 99: 146-8.—Haas, G. Ueber drusenahnliche Gebilde der Epidermis am Kopfe von Tvphlops braminus. Zschr. Zellforsch., 1932, 16: 745-52.—Heddergott, H. Kopf und Vorderdarm von Panorpa communis L. Zool. Jahrb., Abt. Anat., 1938, 65: 229-94.—Kesteven, H. L. The anatomy of the head of Callorhynchus antarcticus. J. Anat., Lond., 1933, 67: 443-74, 2 pl.—Smreczynski, S. Embryologische Unter- suchungen iiber die Zusammensetzung des Kopfes von Silpha obscura L. (Coleopt.) Zool. Jahrb., Abt. Anat., 1932, 55:233- 314.—Thore, S. Ueber Statocysten und Frontalorgane bei Gammarus pulex und Gammarus locusta. Ibid., 489-504.— Towarnicki, R. Ueber den Hakenapparat am Vorderende der Schmeissfliegenlarven (Calliphora vomitoria) Bull, internat. Acad, polon. sc, 1936, ser. B, pt 2, 547-64, pl. HEADACHE. See also Earache; Facial nerve, Neuralgia; Migraine; Toothache; Trigeminus, Neuralgia, &c, also names of primary diseases and condi- tions as Blood pressure, high; Brain tumor; Cranium, Intracranial pressure, &c. Curschmann, H. Kopfschmerz, Migrane, Schwindel. p.1497-1517. 8? Berl., 1939. In Handb. inn. Med. (G. v. Bergmann [et al.]) Berl., 3. Aufl., 5: T. 2, 1939. Dutton, W. F. Headache and head pains. 301p. 23Kcm. Phila., 1939. Fumarola, G. Le cefalee. 103p. 19cm. Fir. [1939] Jolubev, H. F. [Headaches] 36p. 8? [Leningr., 1927] Robey, W. H. Headache. 234p. 8? Phila. [1931] Schuller, A., & Wilder, J. Der Kopfschmerz; mit einem Anhang: Rontgenologie bei Kopf- schmerzen. 90p. 8? Wien, 1934. Abrahams, A. Headache. Lancet, Lond., 1931, 2: 819.— Armour, R. G. Headache. N. York State J. M., 1927, 27: 1120-4.—Barnard, F. S. Pain in the head. Pacific Coast J. Homoeop., 1936, 47: 211.—Barrio y Penarredonda. Cefalalgia Rev. med. contemp., Madr., 1911, 33: 323-5.—Berardinelli, W. As dores de cabeca. Arch, brasil. med., 1928, 18: 798-804, ch.—Berwald, W. P. E., & Williams, H. W. Headache. Mil. Surgeon, 1941, 88: 504-9. Also repr.—Blassingame, C. D. Headaches. N. Orleans M. & S. J., 1925-26, 78: 836-40.— Bortz, W. M. Headache. In Cyclop. Med. (Piersol-Bortz) Phila., 1939, 7: 109-12.—Buchanan, C. C. Headache. N. Orleans M. & S. J., 1926-27, 79: 490-6.—Butler, T. H. Head- ache. Birmingham M. Rev., 1939, 14: 85-96.—Coolidge. L. E. Sick headache and other tvpes of headache. Life & Health, Wash., 1935, 50: No. 9, 8.—Craie, W. M. The hemicrania of migraine. Proc Mayo Clin., 1935, 10: 362-4.—Curschmann, H. Ueber Kopfschmerz und Migrane. Med. Welt, 1940, 14: 1117-21.—Cutler, E. C. Headache. Proc. Interst. Postgrad. M. Ass. N. America, 1935, 336-9.—Dreyfoos. M. Headache. "J. Med., Cmcin., 1933,14:63-74. Also repr.—Drury, D. Head- ache. N. England J. M., 1928,199:167-75. Also Laryngoscope; 1928, 28: 165-84— Ely, F. A. Headache. J. Iowa M. Soc, 1934, 24: 429-31.—Evans, G. Headache. S. Barth. Hosp. J., Lond., 1934-35, 42: 188-91.—Fassett, B. W. Headache. North Carolina M. J., 1940, 1: 478-84.—Fumarola, G. II dolor di capo. Athena, Roma, 1934, 3: 304-8.—Griffith, A. D. Headaches. Lancet, Lond., 1934, 2: 327-9.—Harasukh Rai. Headache. J. Ind. M. Ass., 1935-36, 5: 46-51.—Hays, H. Comments on headaches. Med. Times, N. Y., 1939, 67: 555- 7.—Hughes, W. F. Headache. Tr. Indiana Acad. Ophth. Otolar., 1931, 63.—Le Hew. J. L. Headache. J. Oklahoma M. Ass., 1933, 26: 239-44.—Ley, C. A. Headache. Hahne- man. Month., 1936, 71: 591-7.—Long, C. F. Headache. Kentucky M. J., 1939, 37: 116-20.—Mackenzie, G. W. Head- ache. Med. World, 1940, 58: 685.—McLaughlin, C.R. Head- ache. Maine M. J., 1937, 28: 266-8.—Mahoney, P., & Agar, J. S. Headaches. South. M. J., 1941, 34: 956-9.—Maselli, M. La cefalee. Riv. med., 1934, 42: 97; 117.—Ortner, N. Kopf- schmerz. Zschr. arztl. Fortbild., 1930, 27: 613-7.—Osborne, O. T. Headache. Med. J. & Rec, N. Y., 1932, 137: 5.— Parrish, R. E. Headache. Texas J. M., 1930-31, 26: 477- 82.—Parsons, J. C. Headache. J. Iowa M. Soc, 1940, 30: 470-3.—Paulson, T. S. Headaches. J. Lancet, 1926, 46: 167- 70.—Primlari, C. H. Headache. Sind M. J., 1934-35, 7: 108-13.—Pritchard. W. W. W. Headache. J. Am. Osteopath. Ass., 1933, 32: 434.—Purves Stewart, J. Las cefaleas. Dfa med., B. Air., 1940, 12: 84-6.—Rai, H. Headache. Pract. Med., Delhi, 1933, 31: 45-51.—Ramond, L. Un drole de mal de tete. Presse med., 1934, 42: 2103.— Riddoch, G. Head- ache. Lancet, Lond., 1933, 2: 1107-9.—Riley, H. A. Head- ache. Arch. Otolar., Chic, 1939, 30: 845-7.—Sands. I. J. Headache. Hvgeia, Chic, 1937, 15: No. 7, 606.—Schaffler, J. rHemicrania] Orv. hetil.. 1938, 82: meU., 42.—Shuman, J. W. Headache. Med. J. & Rec, 1927, 125: 447.—Smith, J. W. Headache. J. Med. Pract., 1936, 1: 70.—Sombor, J. A. [Headache] Gvogvaszat, 1936, 76: 631; 648; 668; 681.—Some remarks about headaches. West. M. Times, 1933, 52:119-22.— Sydenham, F. W. Headache. Birmingham M. Rev., 1929, 4: 332-40, 2 pl.—Symonds, C. P. Headache. Guv's Hosp. Gaz., Lond., 1929, 43: 311-5. Also Clin. J., Lond., 1930, 59: 25-30. Also in Brit. Encycl. M. Pract. (Rolleston, H.) Lond., 1937, 6: 199-204.—Tilney, F. Headache and migraine. Bull. N. York Acad. M., 1930, 2. ser., 6: 69-88.—Trotter, W. Headache. Clin. J., Lond., 1926, 55: 481-5.—Varnpre, E. Sobre urn caso interessante de cephaWa intensa. Bol. Soc med. cir. S. Paulo, 1923-24, 3. ser., 6: 123.—Von Storrh, T. J. C. Headache. In Modern Med. Ther. (Barr, D. P.) Bait., 1940, 2: 2053-68 — Voss, G. Der Kopfschmerz. Deut. med. Wschr., 1939, 65: 762.—Warren, E. D. Headaches. Northwest M., 1940, 39: 412-6—Wilson, R. G. Headache. South. M. & S., 1926, 88: 664-7.—Wolff, H. G. Headache. Canad. Nurse, 1941, 37: 24-6.—Woodbridge, C. L. Headache. Kentucky M. J., 1937, 35: 24.—Zandowa, N. [Cephalalgia] Wa.rsz. czas. lek:, 1938, 15: 69-72. ---- allergic. Alexander, H. L. Allergic headaches. In Modern Med. Ther. (Barr, D. P.) Bait., 1940, 1: 1005.—Armbrecht. R. J. Allergic headache. West Virginia M. J., 1936, 32: 321 — Brown, L. A., & Fort, A. G. Headaches of aUergic origin. Bull. Fulton Co. M. Soc, 1937, 11: No. 21, 3.—Cocriamont. Cepha- ses et traitement par methode de d^sensibilisation. Bruxelles med., 1933-34, 14: 593-5.—Eyermann, C. H. Allergic head- ache. J. Allergy, 1930-31, 2: 106-12. Also J. Missouri M. Ass., 1931, 28: 480.—Fabrizio, A. L'emicrania allergica. Rinasc. med., 1935, 12: 73.—Forman, J. Migraine-like head- ache due to allergy. Ohio M. J.. 1932, 29: 28-31.—Hartsock, C. L., & McGurl, F. J. Allergy as a factor in headache. Med. Clin. N. America, 1938, 22: 325-31.—Hinnant, I. M. Headache of allergic origin. Cleveland Clin. Q., 1935, 2: No. 3, 72-5 — Rudolph, J. A. The present status of allergic headache. Ohio M. J., 1937. 33: 173-7.—Sheldon, J. M., & Randolph, T. G. Allergy in migraine-like headaches. Am. J. M. Sc, 1935, 190: 232-7. Also repr.—Stolkind. E, Allergic headache. Proc. R. 24 HEADACHE HEADACHE Soc. M.. Lond. 1932, 25: 1396. Also repr.—Thomas. J. W., & Johnston, C. R. K. Headaches of allergic origin. Med. Clin. N. America, 1940, 24: 285-99.—Vaughan, W. T. An analysis of the allergic factor in recurrent paroxysmal headache.*. Tr. Ass. Am. Physicians, 1934, 49: 348-57. Also J. Allergy, 1934-35,6:365-82. ----— Allergic headache. South. M. J., 1935, 28: 267-9.—Walt. J. M. The treatment of allergic headache. S. Afr. J. M. Sc, 1938, 3: 95-101. ---- cardio-vascular. See also subheading vasomotor. Spatz, A. *Kopfschinerzen und Hypotonie [Bern] 23p. 21cm. Frankf., 1939. Birk, B. J. Headache in cardiovascular renal diseases. Wis- consin M. J 1934, 33: 674-7.—Lindsey, W.H. Cardiovascular headache and its treatment. Ther. Gaz., Detr., 1927, 51: 84- 7.—Luft, H. Ursachen und Behandlung von Kopfschmerzen bei Hypertome. Med. Welt, 1938, 12: 205.—McDonald, R.H. Headache of renal origin. Cleveland Clin. Q., 1935, 2: 59-61. Also Med. Clin. X. America, 1940, 24: 365-8.—Tucker, J. Headache in cardiovascular disease. Ibid., 321-7. ---- chronic. Cabot, R. C. Two weeks' headache. N. England J. M., 1932, 207: 1101-3.-—Cantonnet, A. Les cephalees persistantes aprSs les traumatismes du crane; importance de l'examen oculaire. Rev. gen. clin. ther., 1932, 46: 177.—Carpenter, E. R. Surgical treatment of chronic headache and pain in the head. Southwest. M., 1926, 10: 61-3. ------ Surgical aspect of chronic headache. Dallas M. J.. 1929, 15: 29-32. ------ Surgical considerations of chronic headache. Med. J. & Rec, 1930,132:374-7.—Draper, P. A. Chronic headache. Colorado M., 1937, 34: 566-7(1. Also J. Nerv. Ment. Dis., 1938,87: 26- 44.—Headaches of 18 davs' duration; presentation of case. N. England J. M., 1938, 218: 531 3. Liebermann, T. [Ton- sillectomy as treatment for constant headache] Budapesti orv. ujs., 1929, 28: 291.—Ziegelroth. L. Der chronische Kopfschmerz und seine physikidisrhe Behandlung. Zschr. ges. phys. Ther., 1927, 34: 12-23. Also Psychiat. neur. Wschr., 1928, 30: 395-400. ---- Clinical aspect. Admitted to the hospital complaining of severe headaches. X. Kngland J. M., 1940, 223: 294-7.- Ainsworth, H. Head- ache from medical aspect. J. M. Ass. Georgia, 1933, 22: 430.— Amyot, R. La c£phalee en neuro-psvehiatrie. Union mid. Canada, 1932, 61: 1243; 1310; passim.—Baker, < . M. Head- aches from the standpoint of the general practitioner. Tri- state M. J.. 1934, 7: 1380.—Brown, J. A. Some clinical aspects of head pain associated with sympathetic phenomena. South. M. J., 1936, 29: 1002-6.—Dawson, L. Some varieties pf head- ache. Brit. M. J., 1927, 1: 607-9. Also Canad. M. Ass. J., 1927, 17: 389-93.—Elliott, B. L. Headache from the neuro- logical aspect. J. Missouri M. Ass., 1928, 25: 509-14.— Gordon, H. L. Headache in Kenya. East Afr. M. J., 1937-38, 14: 189-98.—Guiral, R. J. Sobre un tipo de cefalalgia. Arch. med. int., Habana, 1939, 5: 182-7.—Kamman, G. R. Head- aches from a neurologic standpoint. Minnesota M., 1928, 11: 231-8.—Klemme, R. M. Headaches; their neurosurgical aspect. Laryngoscope, 1928, 28: 149-54.—Knight, G. The clinical problem of headache. Med. Press & Circ, Lond., 1941, 205: 226-30.—Northfleld. D. W. C. Some observations on headache. Brain, Lond., 1938, 61: 133-62.—Oaks, L. W., & Merrill. H. G. The role of headaches in everv-day practice. k> e Kai \c. Month., 1928, 7: 415-9.— Ranschburg, P. [Head- ache ami the general practitioner] Gydgydszat, 1935, 75: 371; 38S: 40S.--Rosenberger, A. I. Headaches from the standpoint of i he neurologist. Wisconsin M. J., 1934, 33: 576.—Sptiggs, E. A clinical study of headaches. Lancet, Lond., 1935, 2: 1; 63.— Vonderahe, A. R. Symposium on headache; from the stand- point of the neurologist. Tr. Am. Acad. Ophth. Otolar., 1935, 40: 109-16.—Waleh, J. J. Forty-five years of personal ex- perience with headache. Intrnat. CUn., 1930, 40. ser., 3: 135- 47.—Wilbur, D. L., & French, L. R. Headaches of chronic or recurring type; considered from the viewpoint of the internist. California West, M., 1939, 51: 362-7.—Woltman, H. W. Headache; a consideration of some of the more common types. Med. Clin. N. America, 1940, 24: 1159-70. ---- Diagnosis. Auerbach, S. Die Differentialdiagnose und Behandlung der verschiedenen Formen des Kopfschmerzes. 56p. 8? Miinch., 1922. Bellaire, M. J. * Varieties of headache [Marquette Univ.] 26p. 4? Milwaukee, 1930. Barre\ J. A. Sur l'importance de la classification eLiologico- clinique des cephalees. Rev. otoneur., Par., 1929, 7: 607.— Cephalea; diagnostico e tratamento. Rev. clin. S. Paulo 1940 8: 17-24.—Cohen, H., Curran, D. [et al.] Headache as an early symptom. Brit. M. J., 1939, 2: 299-301.—Draig, W. M. Diagnosis and treatment of pain about the face and head J. M. Ass. Alabama, 1936-37, 6: 296-9.—Fay, T. A new test for the diagnosis of certain headaches; the cephalalgiogram Dit. Nerv. Syst., 1940, 1: 312-5- Fenton, R. A. Differentia- tion between ophthalmic and sinus headaches. Ann. Otol. Rhinol., 1927, 36: 1000-18.—Freyermuth, O. G. Head pains; their significance. Pacific Coast. J. Homoeop., 1931. 42: 59-65.— (Jirschek. K. Beurteilung und Behandlung von Kopfschmerzen in der Praxis. Munch, med. Wschr., I'.i:;s, 85: 1868-71.—Grant, F. C. The significance of head pain. >wtg. Clin. X. America, 1935, 15: 3-11.—Haguenau, J. I.e diagnostic des cephalees. Progr. med., Par., 1937, 1382 91. Halliday, J. L. A studv in the symptomatology of headache. Glasgow M. J., 1920, 106: 281-305.—Hudgins, A. P. Headache and its significance. West Virginia M. J., 1932, 28: 158-62.—Jones, C. C. Headaches; their etiology and differential diagnosis. J. Iowa M. Soc, 1934, 24: 559-65.—Moorehead. F. B. The interpretation of head pains. Dent. Cosmos, 1926, 68: 1150- 5.—N., A. G. Some diagnostic aspects of headache. Canad. M. Ass. J., 1940, 42: 175.—Pollock, L. J. Head pain; differ- ential diagnosis and treatment. Med. Clin. X. America, 1941, 25:3-13.—Scetta.G. La diagnosi deUe cefalee. Gazz.internaz. med. chir., 1934, 42: 81.—Schuller, A. The Roentgen-ray findings in a series of cases of headache. Radiology, 1926, 7: 190-200.—Thorburn. O. L. Headache; problems in diagnosis. J. Iowa M. Soc, 1931, 21: 167-72.- Trautmann, E. Klinische Untersuchungen zu einer topischen Diagnostik des Kopf- schmerzes. Deut. Zschr. Xervenh., 1929,110:67-94. ------ Differentialdiagnose des Kopfschmerzes. Med. Welt, 1932, 6: 1132.—Voss, G. Fehldiagnosen bei Kopfschmerz. Deut. med. Wschr.. 1934. 60: 1278-80. Also in Samml. wicht. Fruhdiagn., Lpz., 1936, 1-8.—Wright, C. D. Study of differ- ential diagnosis of head pain. J. Lancet, 1930, 50: 51-8. ---- dural and intracranial. Boyd, D. Post-traumatic headache treated by spinal insufflation of air. Arch. Surg., 1929, 18: 1626-36— Bunts, A. T. Headaches caused by intracranial lesions. Med. Clin. N. America, 1940, 24: 301-9.—Campailla, G. Emicrania emiplegica. Gior. psichiat., 1936, 64: 385-92.—Castagna, P. Sindrome cefalalgica post-traumatica. Policlinico, 1928, 35: sez. prat., 282 6. Cloward, R. B. Post traumatic headache; pathology and treat ment. Proc. Clinic, Honolulu, 1938, 4: No. 11, 1-5.—Cohen, H. Intracranial causes of headache. Brit. M. J., 1939, 2: 713-6.—Craig, W. M. Localized headache associated with lesion of meningeal vessels. J. Am. M. Ass., 1933, 100: 816.- Headaches caused by stretch of brain's blood vessels. Science News Lett., 1936, 29: 375.—Jessen, H. (Treatment of traumatic headaches by insufflation] Ugeskr. laeger, 1933, 95: 611.—Laruelle, L. Le traitement des ce- phalees post-traumatiques et de certaines cephalees chroniques d'origine ind£termin£e par de petites insufflations d'air, selon la technique du repdrage ventriculugraphique. Rev. beige sc. med., 1934, 6: 439-44.—Nelson, M. O. Post puncture head- aches; a clinical and experimental study of the cause and pre- vention. Arch. Derm. Syph., ' Chic," 1930, 21: 615-27 — Penfield, W. Chronic meningeal (post-traumatic) headache and its specific treatment by lumbar air insufflation; ence- phalography. Surg. Gyn. Obst., 1927, 45: 747-89.----— A contribution to the mechanism of intracranial pain. Proc. Ass. Res. Nerv. Ment, Dis., 1934, 15: 399-416. ----- Dural headache and the innervation of the dura mater. Clin. Bull. Cleveland, 1938, 2: 66.------& Norcross, N. Subdural traction and post-traumatic headache; a pathological and therapeutic study. Tr. Am. Neur. Ass., 1935, 61: 86. Also Arch. Neur. Psychiat., Chic, 1936, 36, 1: 75-95.—Portmann, G. La cephalee dans le syndrome d'hypertension intracranienne. Rev. laryng., Par., 1931, 52: 1-10. ------ & Retrouvey, H. La cdphalee dans l'abces ciribral et c£reL>elleux d'origine otique. Ibid., 1929, 50: 537-40.—Reichert, F. L. Specific treatment of posttraumatic localized headache by subarachnoid pneumotherapy. Surg. Clin. N. America, 1931, 11: 1123-31.— Roger, H., & Audier, M. Cephalees paroxystiques chez une ancienne memngitique ayant eu des poussdes d'hypertension intracranienne, tendance k la rachicente'somanie. Rev. oto- neur., Par., 1934, 12: 289-93.—Simonton, K. M. Headache associated with localized chronic epidural abscess following radical mastoid operation; report of 2 cases. Proc. Mayo Clin., 1939, 14: 385-7.—Skinner, H. L. Headache (post- traumatic) relieved by lumbar air insinuation; report of a case. Am. J. Surg., 1930, n. ser., 8: 842—Tinel, J. Le cipha\ie k l'effort; syndrome de distension douloureuse des veines intra- craniennes. Medecine, Par., 1932, 13: 113 8.—Treachenor, F. R. Headaches of intracranial origin. Laryngoscope, 1927; 37: 320-5.—Wolff, H. G. Headache and cranial arteries, abstract. Tr. Ass. Am. Physicians, 1938, 53: 193-8. ---- endocrine. See also Pituitary, Tumor. Bailey, W. M. Pituitary headache. Tristate M. J., 1934-35, 7: 1517-9.—Barre\ J. A. Cephases de l'adolescent. Rev. otoneur., Par., 1929, 7: 609.—Blanco Soler, C. Un caso de cefalea hipofisana. An. Hosp. S. Jose\ Madr., 1929-30, 1: 219-24, pl.—Browning, W. H. Pituitary headaches. Tristate M. J 1931, 3: 596-9.^Chauvet, S. La mysterieuse cdphalea dite de croissance (cephalee hypophvsaire) Clinique, Par., 1926, 21: 121-4.—Cushman. B. Studies of the visual fields in functional headaches of pituitary origin Tr Am M Ass Sect. Ophth., 1933, 58-78. Also j. Am. M. Ass., 1933, 101: 837^43. Also repr.—Fox. N. Nasal headaches of endocrinal 'origin. Dis. Eye &c. Throat, 1941, 1: I3_g—Kogerer H HEADACHE 125 HEADACHE Emicrania e tiroide. Gazz. osp., 1937, 58: 802.—Lemos, F. de. Cephalea hypophysaria da puberdade. Bol. Acad. nac. med., Rio, 1930, 102: 337-56.—McMahon, A. Endocrine headaches. Tr. Am. Ther. Soc, 1938, 38: 18-25. Also Radiol. Rev., 1938, 60: 143-8.—Maranon. G. Los factores endocrinos de la cefalea y la jaqueca. Dia med., B. Air., 1937, 9: 378; 383.— Mayers, L. H. Pituitary headache. Endocrinology, 1930, 14: 319-27.—Popea, A., & Dimolescu, A. Contribution a l'etude de l'ctiologie, la pathogenie et le traitement de la cephale'e puberale. Rev. me"d. roumain, 1930, 3: 121; 169.— Sexton, D. L. Headaches associated with endocrine disorders. J. Missouri M. Ass., 1933, 30: 393-8.—Stevens, N. C. Endo- crine and fatigue headaches. N. England J. M., 1929, 201: 801-5.—Sure, J. H. Endocrine headaches. Wisconsin M. J., 1934, 33: 671-3. ---- Etiology. See also subheadings; also names of primary diseases as Arteriosclerosis; Brain abscess; Encephalitis; Meningism; Meningitis; Syphilis, &c. Reilly, T. F. Headache; its causes and treat- ment. 246p. 8? Phila. [1926] Wright, H. G. Headaches, their causes and cure. 140p. 12? N. Y., 1856. Ambraziejute-S [Causes of headaches] Medicina, Kaunas, 1929, 10: 900-9.—Arbuckle, M. F. Headache: its cause and relief. J. Missouri M. Ass., 1931, 28: 579-87.—Barker, L. F. On the nature and treatment of maladies that cause head- aches. Internat. Clin., 1929, 39. ser., 1: 8-15. ------ Head- aches; gigantism and infantilism; multiple sclerosis. Proc. Interst, Postgrad. M. Ass. N. America (1928) 1929, 443-53.— Bass, A. L. Cephalalgia and some of its causes. Kentucky M. J., 1935, 33: 348-5L—Borghesan, E. Anomalia dell'apo- fisi crista galli considerata quale probabile fattore di cefalea. Riv. otoneur., 1936, 13: 456-77.—Brown, E. H. Etiology of headache. Dis. Eye &c Throat, 1941, 1: 230-3.—Bunts, A. T. Headache of neurological origin. Cleveland Clin. Q., 1935, 2: No. 3, 69-71.—Cohen, H., Curran, D. [et al.] Symptomatic headache. Lancet, Lond., 1939, 2: 693.—Cohen, J. Ueber Kopfschmerzen durch retinierte Zahne. Zschr. Laryng., 1929-30, 19: 225-8.—Cold medulla. J.'Med. Pract., 1936, 1: 5.—Emerson, C. P. Causes of headache. J. Indiana M. Ass., 1936, 29: 415-8.—Fischer, R. M. Obscure head pains of oral origin. Dent. Cosmos, 1936, 78: 800-11, 12 pl.—Galdi, F. L'emicrania meteorotropa. Riforma med., 1940, 56: 339-44.— Geimanovich, A. I. [Pains of the visceral circle especially in the region of the head] Arkh. biol. nauk, 1937, 48: 77-89 — Hartsock, C. L. Headache from arthritis of the cervical spine. Tr. Am. Ther. Soc, 1940, 40: 45-7. Also Med. Clin. N. America, 1940, 24: 329-33.—Kasparek, A. Beziehungen der Kopfschmerzen zu Erkrankungen anderer Organe. Mitt. Biochem., Lage, 1933, 40: 188-91.—Koopman, J. [A case of headache (billions of influenza bacilli in blood—do not laugh!)] Geneesk. gids, 1927, 5: 949.—Lindquest. A. B. Headache; symptomatic and undetermined. Nebraska M. J., 1938, 23: 187-9.-—McGregor, G. D. Headaches due to general diseases. South. M. & S., 1930, 92: 69-71.—Maliwa. E. Ueber einige Scnderformen peripher ausgeloster Kopfschmerzen. Aerztl. Prax., Wien, 1938. 12: 254.—Neblett, H. C. Headache not of ocular origin. South. M. & S., 1941, 103: 265.—Nielsen, J. M. Headaches; etiology. California West. M., 1935, 42: 115-21 — Origin of headache. Brit. M. J., 1939, 1: 929.—Perreymond (fils) H^micranie par affection dartreuse. Observ. sc. med., 1825, 9: 289.—Tilney, F. Etiological considerations of head- ache. Bull. N. York Acad. M., 1935, 11: 500-10.—Woltman, H. W. The svmptom of headache and some conditions sug- gested by it. Minnesota M., 1940, 23: 19-25. ---- gastrointestinal. Annes Dias, H. Emicrania duodenale; patogenesi e tratta- mento. Rinasc. med., 1932, 9: 103-5.—Hartsock, C. L. Headache of gastro-intestinal origin. Cleveland Clin. Q., 1935, 2: No. 3, 55-8. Also Pittsburg M. Bull., 1935, 24: 638-44. Also Med. Clin. N. America, 1940, 24: 341-8 — Khoroshko, V. K. [Specific headache associated with decrease of gastric secretion] Klin, med., Moskva, 1930, 8: 918.— Lewin, L. Klinische Beobachtungen iiber den Zusammenhang von Kopfschmerzen und Erkrankungen des Magendarmkanals. Schweiz. med. Wschr., 1937, 67: 190.—Portis, S. A. The relation of headache to upper abdominal distress. Med. Clin. N. America, 1929-30, 13: 1277-83. ---- localized. Anosov, N. N. [Significance of the carotid sinus in certain stabilized, unilateral headaches] Vopr. neirokhir., 1941, 5: No. 2, 80-5.—Cefalalgia (La) nucal matutina por celulitis. Dfa mid., B. Air., 1940, 12: 363.—Frontal, right, temporal headache. Optometr. Week., 1940-41, 31: 1440.—Mallory, T. B. Severe frontal headache. N. England J. M., 1941, 224: 1071-3.—Trautmann, E. Die Differentialdiagnose der Stirn- Kopfschmerzen. Med. Welt, 1930, 4: 705-7.—Weiss, L. The cause and treatment of some frontal headaches, with report of cases. Laryngoscope, 1930, 40: 892-9. ---- myalgic [indurative, or rheumatic] Du Botjchet [nee Vilter] N. *Myocellulite cervicale et cephalees. 78p. 8? Par., 1931. Cyrisx, J. Rheumatic headache. Brit. M. J., 1938, 2: 1367.—Didsbury, G. C^phalee cellulitique et migraine Sem. hop. Paris, 1930, 6: 509-11.—Glasscheib, A. Zur Patho- genese und Klinik des muskularen (rheumatischen) Kopf- schmerzes. Mschr. Ohrenh., 1927, 61: 105-11.—Hartmann, F. Ueber den Kopfschmerz bei geldser Erkrankung der Korper- decke und seine Stellung in der Pathologic Zschr. ges. Neur. Psychiat., 1930, 128,: 96-8.—Laroche, G. Cephases et cellu- lites. Sem. hop. Paris, 1930, 6: 425-7.—Mithoefer, W. Hyper- tonic muscles of the neck as a cause of headache. Tr. Am Laryng. Ass., 1934, 40: 285-93. Also Ann. Otol. Rhinol., 1934, 43: 67-75.—Peritz, G. Der myalgische Kopfschmerz und die durch ihn bedingten nervdsen Erscheinungen. Zschr. ges. Neur. Psychiat., 1928, 117: 118-27.—SeydelI, E. M. Indurative or myalgic headache. Tr. Am. Laryng. Ass., 1940, 62: 227-54. Also Arch. Otolar., Chic, 1940, 32: 860-76.— Sieber H. Schwielenkopfschmerz und Muskelharten. Zschr arztl. Fortbild., 1929, 26: 187-90. ---- neuralgic and neuritic. See also under names of nerves affected. Brock, S. Neuralgias of the head. Laryngoscope, 1931, 41: 48-56.-—Miner, L. M. S. A contribution to the etiology of neuralgia of the head. N. England M. Gaz., 1910, 45: 560-6.— NiessI von Mayendorf. Ueber die Hygiene des Kopfschmerzes be' der Neuropathic Zschr. psych. Hyg., 1932, 5: 146-50.— Ober, F. R. Headache and cervical neuritis from the ortho- pedic standpoint. Med. Rec, Houston, 1941, 35: 792.— Smith, N. R. Neurological headache. J. Oklahoma M. Ass., 1933, 26: 244. ---- ocular. See also Eye muscles, Disorders; Eye refrac- tion; Eyestrain; Orbit, Tumor, &c. Avizonis, P. [Headache and eve diseases] Klin, med., Moskva, 1926, 4: 277-81.—Bahn, C. A. Headaches of ocular origin. N. Orleans M. & S. J., 1932, 85: 177-80.—Beavieux, Piechaud, F., & Rudeau. Cephalees et spasro.es vasculaires en ophtalmologie. Rev. otoneur., Par., 1929, 7: 619-25.— Berrie, L. H. Ocular headaches; some of their common causes. Maine M. J.. 1938, 29: 195-7.—Brooks, H. L. Headaches from the standpoint of the oculist. Clin. M. & S., 1927, 34: 435-9.-—Cephalees (Les) d'origine oculaire. Bev. gin. clin. ther., 1934, 48: 234—Ciiep, W. H. Symposium on headache; from the standpoint of the ophthalmologist. Tr. Am. Acad. Ophth. Otolar., 1935, 40: 97-108. Also Am. J. Ophth., 1936, 3. ser., 19: 93-100.—Davis, W. T. Asthenopia and headache, not of ocular origin; differential diagnosis. N. Orleans M. & S. J., 1935-36, 188: 158-68.—De Schweinitz, G. E. Headaches, with especial reference to those of ocular origin. Canad. M. Ass. J., 1926, 16: 1314-9.—DuPlessis, G. L. Headaches. Am. J. Optometr., 1940, 17: 375-84.—Elvin, N. C. Ocular headache. Med. Rec, N. Y., 1941, 153: 317-9.—Fullenwider, C. M. Ophthalmological headache. J. Oklahoma M. Ass., 1933, 26: 247-9.—Fuller, W. H. Ocular headaches. Nat. Eclect. M. Ass. Q., 1941-42, 33: 28-32.—Gilleit, W. G. Head- aches due to the eye. Laryngoscope, 1927, 37: 313-6.— Goar, E. L. Headaches that concern the ophthalmologist. Med. Pec, Houston, 1940, 34: 528.—Green, J. Headaches from the standpoint of the ophthalmologist. Laryngoscope, 1928, 38: 143-8.—Griffith, A. The eyes as a cause of headache. Brit. M. J., 1934, 2: 296.—Guist, G. Ueber den Zusam- menhang zwischen Kopfschmerz und Auge. Wien. klin. Wschr., 1929, 42: 1363.—Headaches of ocular origin. Bull. Pract. Ophth., S. Franc, 1938, 8: 39-41.—Henry, W. J. Headache chart. Optometr. Week., 1934-35, 25: 601.—Horner, W. D. Headaches; from the point of view of the ophthalmologist. California West. M., 1939, 51: 367-9.—Knzass, I. I. [Diag- nostic role of the eyes in headaches] Vrach. gaz., 1929, 33: 3-7.—Kershner, W. E. Ocular headache. Maine M. J., 1937, 28: 259-62.—Ligertwood, L. M. Ocular headaches. Tr. Med. Chir. Soc. Edinburgh, 1928-29, 108: 101-10.—McAlester. A. W., jr. Headaches of ocular origin. J. Missouri M. Ass., 1933, 30: 30.-—Medrano, I. R. Cefalalgias de origen ocular. Inform, med., Valladolid, 1930, 7: 285-9. Also Rev. san. mil., Madr., 1932, 22: 289-93.—Ocular headaches. Bull. Pract, Ophth., S. Franc, 1931, 1: 35-8. Also Brit. M. J., 1934, 2: 309.—Post, L. Headaches of ocular origin. J. Missouri M. Ass., 1928, 25: 503-5—Puglisi-Duranti, G. SuUe mani- festazioni oculari dello sindrome simpatico-cervicale posteriore. Biv. otoneur., 1935, 12: 565-70.—Re, B. V., Picoli, H. R., & Tettamanti, J. Cefaleas de origen ocular. Arch. oft. B. Air., 1941, 16: 163; passim.—Ruedemann, A. D. Headache of ocular origin. Cleveland Clin. Q., 1935, 2: No. 3, 62-5. Also Am. J. Ophth., 1939, 3. ser., 22: 437. Also Proc. Postgrad. Course Ophth. George Washington Univ., 1939, 4: 364-78. Also J. Michigan M. Soc, 1940, 39: 191-3. Also Med. CUn. N. America, 1940, 24: 335-9.—Rutherford, C. W. Ocular equilibrium and head pain. J. Michigan M. Soc, 1928, 27: 160-4.—Rychener, R. O. Headache of ocular origin. Mem- phis M. J., 1937, 12: 66.—Sedan, J. Les cephalees par ametro- pie unilaterale. Rev. otoneur., Par., 1929, 7: 611-3.—Sims, HEADACHE 12G HEADACHE \V. S. Headaches due to refractive, accommodative and muscular anomalies. N. Orleans M. & S. J., 1927-28, 80: 1 i4-7. Snyder. W. S. Ocular headaches. Kentucky M. J., 1J35, 33: 589.- Somerville-Lar«e, L. B. Ocular headache. Irish J. M. Sc. 1940, 6. ser., No. 169. 32-7.— Stanford. J. B. Headache of ocular origin. Memphis M. J., 1940, 15: 111.— Stewart. D. S. Ocular headache. Brit. M. J., 1937, 2: 59 — Tassman, I. S. The distinguishing features of ocular headache. Med. Times, N. Y., 1930, 58: 229.—Terrien, F. De quelques maux de tete d'origine oculaire et de la conduite k tenir. J. med. chir., Par., 1939, 110: 419-24. ------ Bien des maux de tfite reconnaissent une origine oculaire; le role des vices de refraction. Concours med., 1940, 62: 1237.—Teulieres. Valeur semeiologique des cephalees dans les affections in- flammatoires intra-oculaircs ou dans les tumeurs orbitaires. Rev. otoneur., Par., 1929, 7: 615-7.—Thies, O. Kopfschmerz und sein Zusammenhang mit Augenleiden. Med. Welt, 1929, 3: 343-6.—Tucker, J. H. Headaches due to ocular disease. South. M. & S., 1930, 92: 71—Velhagen, K., jr. Der Kopf- schmerz als Zeichen von Aucenerkrankungen. Deut. med. Wschr., 1931, 57: 366-8.—Weeks, W. W. Ocular headache. Bull. X. York Acad. M., 1935, 11: 487-94.—Wilensky, M. C. Headaches caused by eve strain. Southwest. M., 1938, 22: 43-6. Also Med. Surg. Suggestions, Madias, 1939, 8: 71-7.— Zobel. Behandlung von Kopfschmerzen und Neuralgien durch den Augenarzt. Zschr. Augenh., 1938, 95: 137. ---- Otorhinological aspect. See also under names of the nasal sinuses; also Earache; Sphenopalatine ganglion. Hirsch, L. L. *Cephalees et algies cranio- facial d'origine nasale. 96p. 8? Par., 1929. Alden, A. M. Headache and neuralgias of nasal origin. Laryngoscope, 1928, 38: 160-4.—Alexander, S. A. Headache from the standpoint of the rhinologist. Med. Ann. District of Columbia, 1933, 2: 7-9.—Amcsur. C. A. Headaches of nasal origin. J. Ind. M. Ass., 1937-38 7: 127-30.—Aprile, V. Su di una particolare forma di cefalea rinogena. Boll. mal. orecchio, 1940, 58: 81-91.—Atkinson, E. M. Nasal headaches. Brit. M. J., 1927, 2: 264-6. Also Eye Ear &c Month., 1927-28, 6: 448-50.—Babccck, J. W. The role of diseases of the nasal accessory sinuses in headache. Bull. N. York Acad. M., 1935, 11: 481-0.—Bolton, S. M. Headaches of nasal origin. Lister M. J., 1933, 2: 32-7— Borries, G. V. T. Headache associated with disease in the nose. Lancet, Lond., 1936, 1: 1067. Also J. Lar. Otol., Lond., 1936, 51: 720-33, pl.— Ilossche, P. van den. Les cephalees d'origine na.salc Gaz. med. Fiance, 1934, 320-9.— Bouchet, M., & Vial, M. Sur les cephalees d'origine nasale. Progr. med., Par., 1929, 44: 189-93.—Bourgeois. Cephalee d'origine nasale. Ann. otolar., Par., 1933, 227.—Bras well. J. C. The nasal aspects of head- ;ich(K. laryngoscope, 1927. 37: 317-9.—Burnham, H. H. Headache from the nasal wall. Ann. Otol. Rhinol., 1937, 46: 69 -7N. -Buzioanu, G. [Semeiology of cephalea of nasal orisiin] Spitalul, 1934, 54: 401-3. Also Arch, internat. neur., Par.. 1937, 56: 229-38.—Cohn, H. J. Headaches; from the point of view of the otolaryngologist. California West. M., 1939, 51: 369-71.—Costiniu, A., Tetu, L, & Buzolanu, G. Cephalee rhinogene. Otorhinolar. internat., Lyon, 1930, 14: 57-99.—Dabney, S. G. Nasal headache simulating that from eve strain. Kentuekv M. J., 1926, 24: 488-90.—Deeton, W. L. Headache of nasal origin. Cleveland Clin. Q., 1935, 2: No. 3, titi S. — Departout, G. La chirurgie du cornet moyen dans le traitement des cephalees. Presse mid., 1935, 43: 1023.— Di Core, A. Le cefalee persistenti e ribeUi di origine nasale (contributo cUnico-terapeutico) Rass. internaz. clin. ter., 1925, 6: 802-16.—Dintenfass, H. Headache from the stand- point of the rhinologist. Ann. Otol. Rhinol., 1929, 38: 77-86.— Duerto, J. Contribucion al estudio de la patogenia de las cefalalgias rinogenas. Cr6n. med. mex., 1931, 30: 220-2.— Dutheillet de Lamothe, G., & Sourdille, M. Les cephalalgies frontales rhinogenes et leur traitement chirurgical. Ann. mal. oreille, 1930, 49: 678; 785.—Duverger & Bosche. Cephalees et asth6nopie d'origine nasale et sinusienne. Rev. otoneur. Par 1928, 6: 122-4.—Engelen, J. C. [On rhinogenous head- a.-he-] Geneesk. tschr. Ned. Indie, 1939, 79: 2563-76, pl.— Escat. De la cefalalgia otica. Bol. lar. otol., Madr., 1904, 4: 399.—Fernandez Vila. V. Algunas consideraciones sobre las cefalalgias frontales de origen purament nasal. Med. ibera 1935, 29: pt 2. 129-35—Ferreri, G. II mal di capo neUe affe- zioni d_elle prime vie respiratorie. Arch. ital. laring., 1926, 45: 117-24. ------ La cephalee d'origine purement nasale est-eUe vraiment frequente? Rev. otoneur., Par., 1929 7- 631-7. Also Rev. laryng., Par., 1929, 50: 323-32—Finder, G. Ueber Kopfschmerzen nasalen Ursprungs. Zschr iirztl FortbUd., 1928, 25: 793-7— Floridia, F. La cefalea di origine nasale. Gior. med. mil., 1933, 81: 973-80.—Ford, R. Chronic headache and pain in the eyes relieved bv a nasal operation Brit. M. J., 1928. 1: 438.—Gittins, T. R. Headache from pathologic changes in the nose or other causes: differential diagnosis. Arch. Otolar., Chic. 1939, 30: 589; 842.—Glas, E. Ueber ein neues Verfahren, nasale Kopf-clnnerzen gunstig zu beeinflussen. Mschr. Ohrenh., 1932, 66: 574-6.—Grain. La cephalee du cornet moyen. Bull. Soc. med. Paris, 1928 388-90. Also Rev. internat. med. chir., 1928 39- 147' Also Rev. med., Par., 1929, 46: 217-29.—Grove, W. E. Headaches of ocular and nasal origin. Wisconsin M. J., 1934, 33:418-20__ Halloran, G. R. Headache from the oto-rhinoldf-iieal point of view. Med. J. Australia, 1930, 2: 779 82, pl.- Hidphen, E. Les cephalees d'origine naso-sympathique et leur therapeu- tique endonasale. Sem. hop. l'aris, 1926, 3: 96-100. ------ Monbrun & Tournay. Les cephalees en oto-neuro-ophtal- mologie (phvsiologie pathologique et traitement) Rev. oto neur., Par., 1929. 7: 161-242. Also Rev. otoneur., B. Air., 1929, 4: 320; 368.— Hays, H. Ten doctors and a headache. Eye Ear &c .Month., 1938-39, 17: 62.—Headaches of nasal origin. Bull. Pract. Ophth., S. Franc, 1932, 2: 103-6.— Hicguet. Cephalees et nevralgies d'origine nasale. ou sinusalgie et neVralgics sinusales. P. verb. Congr. fr. chir., 1921, 33: 750-4.—Hombach, L. J. Headaches of nasal origin. Laryngo- scope, 1930, 40: 753-8.—Hubby, L. M. Headaches physi- ologically considered with special reference to those of ear, nose and throat origin. Med. Rec, N. Y., 1938, 147: 58-60 — Irgens, E. R. Headache in relation to diseases of the ears, nose and throat. Maine M. J., 1937, 28: 262-5.—Jennings, C. W. The vacuum headache; a frequently overlooked condi- tion. South. M. & S., 1926, 88: 787.—Lacroix, P. Cephalee par absence de sinus frontal. Concours med., 1940, 62: 330.— Lewis, E. R. Headache, drumhead retraction and vacuum formation. Tr. Am. Laryng. Ass., 1933, 39: 504-7. Also Laryngoscope, 1933, 43: 762- 6.— Linn, F. D. Headache from the viewpoint of the otolaryngologist. Memphis M. J., 1937, 12: 68.—McKenzie, W. R. Headache of nasal sinus origin; its interpretation. Dis. Eye &c Throat, 1941, 1: 87-90.— McLaurin, J. G. Headache: its otorhinologic aspects. Texas J. M., 1937-38, 33: 576-81. ------ Headaches of otorhino- logic origin and certain reflexes caused by fifth nerve irritation. Ann. Otol. Rhinol., 1941, 50: 469-91.—Moore, P. M., jr. Headaches of nasal origin. Med. Clin. N. America, 1940, 24: 311-9.—Motley, F. E. Headaches due to sinus disease. South. M. & S., 1930, 92: 72.—Mussun, W. G. An unusual form of nasal headache. Arch. Otolar., Chic, 1939, 29: 39-41.—Pallestrini, E. Su di alcune cefalee dipendenti da malformazioni nasali. Minerva med., Tor., 1930, 21: 657-63.— Pellerin, R. Les cephalees d'origine nasale. J. Hotel Dieu Montreal, 1935, 4: 306-14.—Perez, F. J. Contribucion al estudio de las cefaleas por desviaciones alt as del tabique y anomalias o afecciones del cornete medio. Rev. med. Uosario, 1926. 16: 210-4.—Piper, A. S. "Headache from the stand- point of the otologist. J. Oklahoma M. Ass., 1933, 26: 251.— Proetz, A. W. Headaches of nasal origin. J. Missouri M, Ass., 1928, 25: 505.—Reverchon, L. C6phal6e d'origine nasale k forme otalgique. J. sc. med. Lille, 1930, 48: 5; 87.—Roger, H. La c£phal6e des syndromes de la fente sphenoidale et de l'apex orbitaire. Rev. otoneur., Par., 1929, 7: 581-98.—Sargnon, A. Les cephalees d'origine nasale. J. med. Lyon, 1930, 11: 619-34. Also Riv. otoneur., 1933, 10: 1-18.—Sauer, W. E. Headache of nasal origin. Ohio M. J., 1936, 32: 212-7 — Sieme. L'oxythermie et 1'eLince'le de condensation dans le traitement de cephalees rhinogenes et sinusiennes. Rev, otoneur., Par., 1929. 7: 599.—Singer, R. M. Vacuum frontal headache. Woodlawn Hosp. Clin. Q., 1931, 1: 11-7.—Skillern, R. H. Headaches; the nasal aspect. Tr. Am. Acad. Ophth. Otolar., 1926, 31: 378-87.—Smith, W. O. Headache of nasal origin. J. Oklahoma M. Ass., 1933, 26: 249-51—Szmurlo, J. [Head-aches in affections of the upper respiratory tract and ear] Lek. wojsk., 1937, 30: 65-98—Tankersley," G. Head- ache in relation to the eye, ear, nose and throat. J. Arkansas M. Soc, 1932, 29: 67.—Tilley, H. A very small frontal sinus associated with severe headache; no suppuration present. Proc. R. Soc. M., Lond., 1927-28, 21: Sect. Lar. Otol. 102 — Tobl, P. IHeadache of otic origin] Orv. hetil., 1937, 81: meU., 63.—Vail, H. H. Symposium on headache; from the standpoint of the otolaryngologist. Tr. Am. Acad. Ophth. Otolar., 1935, 40: 85-96.—Vasiliu, D. I. Cephalee d'origine amygdalienne. Rev. otoneur., Par., 1929, 7: 750-4. Also Arch, internat. laryng., Par., 1930, 36: 951-5. Also Dia med., B. Air., 1930-31, 3: 173.—Wahrer, L. Related nasal and eye headaches. Eye Ear &c Month., 1934, 13: 340-2.—Wier, F. A. Nasal obstruction as a specific cause of headache. Clin. Med., 1927, 34: 280-2.------ Headaches caused by traumatic nasal deformities. CUn. M. & S., 1937, 44: 347.—Wilkinson, J. A. Headaches dependent on some disorder of the eye, ear. nose or throat. Tristate M. J., 1934, 7: 1377-9.—Wilson, T. G. Headache of nasal origin. Irish J. M. Sc, 1940, 6. ser., No. 169, 38-42. ---- Pathogenesis. Trotot, R. *Les Cephases; etude semeiolo- gique et pathog6nique; leur mecanisme veineux. 250p. 24>4cm. Par., 1939. Brewer, E. D. The occurrence and significance of headache during ventriculography. BuU. Neur. Inst. N. York, 1937, 6: 12-8.—Capparoni, A. Patogenesi e cura dell'emicrania. PolicUnico, 1926, 33: sez: prat., 685-8.—Chibukmakher, N. B. [Superficial temporal artery and its reciprocal relation to the nerves of the head, based upon data of the neurological clinic on pain syndromes in the head] Sovet. psikhonevr., 1940, 16: No. 2, 20-5.—Chideckel, M. Headache: a review of its mech- anism, causation and variations. Med. Rec, N. Y., 1939, 149: 339-42—Clark, D:, Hough, H., & Wolff, H. G. Experi- mental studies on headache: observations on histamine head- ache. Proc. Ass. Res. Nerv. Ment. Dis., 1934 15- 417-36 — Elsberg, C. A., & Southerland, R. W. The etiology of head- HEADACHE 127 HEADACHE ache; headache produced by the injection of air for encepha- lography. Bull. Neur. Inst. N. York, 1933, 3: 519-43.—Fay, T. The mechanism of headache. Tr. Am. Neur. Ass., 1936, 62: 74-7. Also Arch. Neur. Psychiat., Chic, 1937, 37: 471-5.— Gardner, J. W., Mountain, G. E., & Hines, E. A., jr. The relationship of migraine to hvpertension and to hypertension headaches. Am. J. M. Sc, 1940, 200: 50-3.—Goodman. L. Headache; some neurophysiological and pharmacological considerations. Internat. Clin., 1935, 45. ser., 2: 78-98.— Heimanovich, A. I., & Chibukmacher, N. B. Der Sinus caro- ticus und seine Rolle bei dem Schmerz und einigen Gefiiss- phanomenen im Bereich des Kopfes. Acta med. UBSS, 1938, 1: 74-112.—McGee, L. C. The problem of headache. West Virginia M. J., 1937, 33:166-70.—Mtiller, L. R., & Weidner, K. Ueber die Entstehung des Kopfschmerzes. Miinch. med. Wschr., 1936. 83:1355-61.—N., A. G. The genesis of headache. Canad. M. Ass. J., 1940, 42: 71-3.—Paterson, J. E. The mechanism of headache. Glasgow M. J., 1937, 128: 210-9.— Pickering, G. W. Experimental observations on headache. Brit. M. J., 1939, 1: 907-12.—Pisani, D., & Cacchione, A. Contributio clinico alio studio delle emicranie. Note psichiat., Pesaro, 1935, 64: 517-43.—Ratner, I. A. [Pathogenesis and therapy of cephalalgia] Nevropat. psikhiat., Moskva, 1937, 6: 127-34.—Ray, B. S., & Wolff, H. G. Experimental studies on headache; pain-sensitive structures of the head and their significance in headache. Arch. Surg., 1940, 41: 813-56.— Richter, H. Kasuistische Beitrage zur Pathogenese des heroi- kranischen Anfalles. Zschr. ges. Neur. Psychiat., 1928, 113: 604-12—Robb, J. M. The mechanism of headache. Tr. Indiana Acad. Ophth. Otolar., 1937, 63-6.—Salmon, A. L'emicrania: studio su la sua patogenesi. Studium, Nap., 1926, 16: 414; 444. Also repr. ------ Sul meccanismo delle crisi emicraniche. Riv. sper. freniat., 1935, 59: 469- 88.— Schumacher, G. A.. & Wolff, H. G. Experimental studies on headache; contrast of histamine headache with the headache of migraine and that associated with hypertension; contrast of vascular mechanisms in preheadache and in headache phe- nomena of migraine. Arch. Neur. Psychiat., Chic, 1941, 45: 199-214. ------ & Ray, B. S. Experimental studies on headache; further analvsis of histamine headache and its pain pathways. Ibid., 1940, 44: 701-17.—Sutherland, A. M., & Wolff, H. G. Experimental studies on headache; observations on the mechanism of headache in migraine, hypertension and fever therapv. Tr. Am. Neur. Ass., 1938, 64: 103-6. Also Arch. Neur. Psychiat., Chic, 1940, 44: 929-49.—Von Storch. T. J. C. Relation of experimental histamine headache to migraine and non-migraine headache. Ibid., 316-22. ------ Secunda, L., & Kiinsky, C. M. Production and localization of headache with subarachnoid and ventricular air. Ibid., 43: 326-33. ---- Pathophysiology. Hirschfeld, S. "*TJeber periphere vaso- motorische, sekretorische und trophische Sym- ptome im hemikranischen Anfall (nebst Be- merkungen zur Physiopathologie und Therapie der Migrane) [Basel] 29p. 8? Strasb., 1926. Amyot, R. La cephalee et son mvst£re. Union mid. Canada, 1932, 61: 883-6.—Benon, R. Paresthesie de la tete cephalee. Gaz. hop., 1933, 106: 1744-6.—Curschmann, H. Sui rapporti del vomito acetonemico periodico con la emicrania. Riforma med., 1930, 46: 679-82.—D'Osvaldo, E. La tono- scopia retinica nelle cefalee. Rass. ital. ottalm., 1935, 4: 543-9.—Trotot, R. La pression veineuse r£tinienne dans les cephalees. Bull. Soc. opht. Paris, 1937, 91-8. Also Prat. med. fr., 1937, 18: 209-28.—Weidner, K. Pathologische Phvsiologie und Therapie des Kopfschmerzes. Med. Welt, 19.38, 12: 667-9. ---- periodic, and recurrent. Gittins, T. R. Headache: differential diagnosis in periodic types. Tr. Am. Laryng. Ass., 1933, 39: 535-45. Also Ann. Otol. Rhinol., 1933, 42: 463-75. Also J. Iowa M. Soc, 1935, 25: 481-8.—Thomson, A. P. A contribution to the study of intermittent headache. Lancet, Lond., 1932, 2: 229-35.— Worster-Drought, C. Observations on persistent and recurrent headache with special reference to migraine. Postgrad. M. J. Lond., 1939, 15: 258-62. ---- psychoneurotic. Eisenbud, J. The psychology of headache: a case studied experimentally. Psychiat. Q., 1937, 11: 592-619.—McCartney, J. L. Psychogenic headaches, with the treatment of a case. Nat. M. J. China, 1925-26, 12: 359-71.—Sadger, J. Ueber sexualsymbolische Verwertung des Kopfschmerzes. Zbl. Psychoanal., 1911-12, 2: 190-7.—Stekel, W. Zur Psychologie der Schmerzphanomene, insbesondere des Kopfschmerzes. Fortsch. Sexwiss. Psychanal., 1926, 2: 37-103.—Wilson, H. Psychogenic headache. Lancet, Lond., 1938, 1: 367-70.— Winans, H. M. The hurry headache. Texas J. M., 1925-26 21:551-3. ----- toxic. [Kellogg, J. H.] Beefsteak headaches. Good Health, 1941 76: 35.—Kohn, S. E. Headaches of infectious and toxic origin. Wisconsin M. J., 1934, 33: 668-70—Kovats, F. von. Die Be- handlung der Intoxikations-Kopfschmerzen mit Adrenalin (lonogen suprarenale Richter) Med. Klin., Berl., 1926, 22: x?°;7~Lambert, A. Headache from tobacco, drugs, etc. Bull. N. York Acad. M., 1935, 11: 495-9.—Patek, A. J. Headaches of toxic and metabolic origin. Wisconsin M. J., 1934, 33:403-5. ---- Treatment. Bors, D., & Iliescu, P. [Treatment of pre- and post operative cephalea in oto-rhino-laryngology] Romania med., 1936, 15: 14-—Boschi, G. II male di testa e la sua eura. Gior. psichiat., 1931, 59: 61-77.—Brown, H. A. Relief of pain about the head and neck. California West. M., 1941, 55: 17-9.—Catola, G. Cefalee e loro cura. Policlinico, 1929, 36: sez. prat., 843-50.— Ettleson, A. Relief of headaches, facial neuralgia, glosso- pharyngeal neuralgia, superior laryngeal neuralgia, occipital neuralgia, pain from Sluder's neuralgia. Med. Clin. N. America, 1935-36, 19: 1015-31.—Eustis, A. Headaches, causes and treatment. N. Orleans M. & S. J., 1932, 85: 253.—Feiling, A. Headaches and their treatment. Med. Press & Circ, Lond., 1939, 201: Suppl., p. i-v.—Lynch, J. W. Headache; mecha- nism and treatment. Northwest M., 1941, 40: 246-50.— Mezcy, G. [Practical experiences with the causes and treat- ment of headache] Gyogyaszat, 1938, 78: 103; 123.—N., A. G. Some principles underlying the treatment of headache. Canad. M. Ass., J., 1940, 42: 271.—Nlsein, E. A. [Headache; patho- genesis and treatment] Tr. Gosud. nauch. inst. fizioter. Semashko, 1934, 2: 238-56.—Pilcz, A. Ueber Kopfschmerzen und deren Behandlung. Wien. med. Wschr., 1936, 86: 1157- 9. Also Dia med., B. Air., 1938, 10:384-6.—Rose, M. [Head- aches and their treatment] Lek. wojsk., 1937, 29: 193-219.— Schuller, A. Ueber Kopfschmerzen, ihre Untersuchung und Behandlung. Wien. med. Wschr., 1934, 84: 1123.—Seelig- mtiller, A. Einiges iiber den Kopfschmerz, seine Entstehung und Behandlung. Hippokrates, Stuttg., 1939, 10: 127-31.— Young, G. S. Abstract of lecture on the treatment of headache. Bull. Acad. M. Toronto, 1938, 11: 304-7. ---- Treatment: Drugs and hormones. Alvarez, W. C, & Mason, A. Y. Results obtained in the treatment of headache with the inhalation of pure oxygen. Proc. Mayo Clin., 1940, 15: 616-8.—Badia, S. Contribucion al estudio de la cefalalgia y su tratamiento por la phenacetina. Rev. homeop., Barcel., 1891, 2: 196-202.—Biochemischen (Die) Mittel bei Kopfschmerzen. Mitt. Biochem., 1937, 44: 153-6.—Carnot, P., Caroli, J., & Cachera, R. Sur Taction antic^phalalgique de l'extrait de lobe posterieur d'hypophyse. Paris med., 1932, 85: 392.—Cephalee des femmes nerveuses trait^e avec succes par les capsules de t6r6benthine. J. mid. Toulouse, 1863, 4. ser., 2: 79.—Crandall, L. A., jr, & Roberts, G. M. The treatment of periodic headache with chondroitin sulphuric acid. Illinois M. J., 1933, 63: 513-9. —---- & Snorf, L. D. The use of chondroitin in idiopathic headache (including migraine) Am. J. Digest. Dis., 1936-37, 3:289-96 — Crichlow, R. S. Treatment of headache with theelin. N. Orleans M. & S. J., 1938-39, 91: 490.—Crohn, W. H. Zusam- menstellung von Mitteln gegen Kopfschmerzen, Schlaflosigkeit, Stuhlverstopfung. Med. Klin., Berl., 1930, 26: 1755-7 — Dultz, G. Ueber Kopfschmerzmittel. Hippokrates, Stuttg., 1941, 12: 402-5.—Hafi Yasa, A. [Hormone therapy for obsti- nate headaches in young girls and women] Askeri sihhiye mecmuasi, 1940, 69: 36-9.—Kistler, C. J. Some useful head remedies. Hahneman. Month., 1936, 71: 104-6.—Lennox, W. G., Von Storch, T. J. C, & Solomon, P. The effect of ergotamin tartrate on non-migrainous headaches. Am. J. M. Sc, 1936, 192: 57-61.—Liber, B. Another headache remedy. N. York State J. M., 1938, 38: 646.—Libersohn, G. Ya [Treat- ment of hemicrania] Klin, med., Moskva, 1931, 9: 1228-30.— Mester, E. Zur Frage der Decholinwirkung bei Kopfschmerzen. Med. Klin., Berl., 1933, 29: 227.—Poudre contre les maux de tdte rebelles. Gaz. san., Par., 1835, 4: 94.—Scimone, V. La terapia calcica deU'emicrania. Minerva med., Tor., 1930, 21: 859-64.-—Vogt, V. Pituitary extract as a remedy against hemicrania. China M. J., 1929, 43: 1235-7. ---- Treatment: Miscellaneous methods. Nagel, K. *Lumbalpunktion bei Kopf- schmerz. 20p. 8? Miinch., 1934. Caboche, H. Traitement de certaines cephalees par I'efflu- vation de haute frequence. Arch, internat. laryng., Par., 1930, 36: 336-54.—Cure varie deU'emicrania. Gazz. osp., 1937, 58: 289-91.—Dimitriu, V., & Stoia, I. [Intraspinal injections of dextrose in headache] Spitalul, 1930, 50: 435.—Foroni, C. Behandlung von Kopfschmerzen mit Oftalmo-Massoressi. Arch. Ophth., Berl., 1939-40, 141: 32-45.—Hanse. Der Kopfschmerz und seine physikalisch-biologische Behandlung. Med. Klin., Berl., 1936, 32: 1071-3.—Joachim, F. Beitrag zur Therapie der Kopfschmerzen. Fortsch. Ther., 1929, 5: 559- 61.—Jessen, H. Treatment of traumatic headache by insuffla- tion of air. Acta psychiat. neur., Kbh., 1933, 8: 71-4.— Joseph, B. Treatment of certain chronic and recurrent head- aches. Med. Rec, N. Y., 1939, 150: 18-21—Jutte, M. E. Successful treatment of headaches and neuralgia by trans- duodenal lavage. Med. Rev. of Rev., 1929, 35: 511-5.— Kennedy, F. Drugs and other methods of treatment. Bull. N. York Acad. M., 1935,11: 511-4.—Liber, B. Another head- HEADACHE 128 HEADACHE ache remedy. In his Your Ment. Health, N. Y., 1940, 197- 200.- Loewe. Habitueller Kopfschmerz und Xervenmassane. Zschr. arztl. 1 ortbild., 1929, 26: 383.—Love, J. G., u alcune cefalee e sindromi dolorose della faccia non dipendenti da affezioni nasali o sinusali. Riv. pat. nerv., 1938, 52: 112-28.—Raab, O. Die Behandlung von chronischen Kopfschmerzen, Ti igeminusneuralgie und Agrypnie mit Dia- thermie und die Erkliirung ihrer Wirkung. Zschr. ges. phys. Ther., 1927, 33: 30-2.—Rives, J. Encephalography as a therapeutic measure against headaches of non-traumatic origin. Fol. neuropath, eston., 1936, 15: & 16: 298-308— Rothacker, A. Weitere Erfahrungen in der Behandlung der Hemikrame mit Thorium-X. Fortsch. Ther., 1926, 2: 692.—Schimert, G-, jr. Experimentelle Unterbauung einer Kopfschmerztherapie. Deut. med. Wschr., 1940, 66: 813-7.—Schoengrun, G. De la remexotWrapie des cephalees. Bull. Acad. meU, Par., 1931, 3 ser, 105: 685-9.—Schiiller, A. Wie behandelt man Kopf- schmerzen? Wien. klin. Wschr., 1927, 40: 1331.—Seeligmtiller, A. Kopfschmerzen und iirztliche (Mesenchym-) Massage. MUnch. med. Wschr., 1937, 84: 618-20.—Tratamiento de las cefaleas de los hipertensos. Dia med., B. Air., 1940, 12: 1066.— Unfeld, E. Homoopathische Behandlung des Kopfschmerzes. Ther. Gegenwart, 1938, 79: 160-4. ---- vasomotor. Baker, B. M. The treatment of periodic headache by injec- tions of histamine. Tr. Ass. Am. Physicians, 1940, 55: 294-7.— Barlow, D. L. The use of histamine in the treatment of neuro- vascular headache. Med. J. Australia, 1940, 2: 421—Besson, J. H. Vascular syndrome headache; report of case with note on mechanism of histamine therapy. Northwest M., 1940, 39: 116. Brickner, R. M., & Riley, H. A. Autonomic facio-cepha- laUia. BuU. Neur. Inst. N. York, 1935, 4: 422-31.—Hoff, H., A 1'ichler, E. Experimentelle Studien zur Frage der peripheren (lefas-iejiulation; iiber den cerebralen Gefiisschmerz. Klin. Wschr., 1935, 14: 51 -3.- Hollander, W. Migrane und vaso- motonsche I >auerkopfs< hmerzen. Ausz. Inaugur. Diss. Med. Fak. 1'mv. Hern (1935-37) 1938, No. 222, 1 -4.— Horton, B. T. The use of histamine m the treatment of specific types of head- aches. J. Am. M. Ass., 1941, 116: 377-S3.------MacLean. A. R., & Craig, W. McK. A new syndrome of vascular head- ache; results of treatment with histamine; preliminary report. Proc. Mayo Clin., 1939, 14: 257-60.—Ipolyi, F. [Intranasal histamin therapv in migraine and headache] Orv. hetil., 1939, 83: 73—Leake, C. D., Loevenhart, A. S., & Muehlberger, C. W. Dilatation of cerebral blood vessels as a factor in headache. J. Am. M. Ass., 1927, 88: 1076.—Poos, F. Klinische Beobach- tungen bei der Hemicrania vasomotoria mit Ausfallserscheinun- gen im Bereiche des Sehorgans. KUn. Mbl. Augenh., 1934, 92: 58-74.—Reid, W. L. The use of histamine in the treatment of neuro-vascular headache. Med. J. AustraUa, 1940, 2: 307; 619.—Roger, H.. & Sarradon. P. Formes cb'niques des spasmes vasculaires sylviens. Presse med., 1934, 42: 130-3.—Yater, \V. M. The vascular headache; report of a case successfully treated with histamine. Med. Ann. District of Columbia, 1940, 9: 165. ---- in children. Blerhmann, G. C6phalee: entre 2 feux. Hopital, 1934, 22: 268.—Carriere, G. Les enfants qui ont mal k la tete. Gaz. med. France, 1928, 2: 358-65.—Chisholm, C. Headache in childhood. Med. Press & Circ, Lond., 1936, 193: 44 — Dreyfus-See, G. Les cephalees chez l'enfant. Presse mid., 1934, 42: 1967.—Marfan, A. B. Sur une forme de cephalee habituelle des ecohers. Ibid., 1935, 43: 1193-5. Also in his Et. mal. enf., Par., 1936, 103-12—Orban, I. [Headaches in childhood] Budapesti orv. uis., 1939, 37: 873-5.—Rudi, R. La cefalea nell'infanzia. Pediat. prat., Mod., 1929, 6: 147- 59.—Sherry, I. L. Headache in infancy and childhood. CUn. M. & S., 1927, 34: 759-64.—Wyllie.W.G. Headache in infancy Med. Press & Circ, Lond., 1937, 194: 102-4. ---— in women. Crossen, H. S. Headache from the gynecological stand- point. J. Missouri M. Ass., 1926, 23: 429.—Gellhorn, G. Headache from the standpoint of the gynecologist. Laryngo- scope, 192>c 38: 15.5-9.—Kahn, M. Ovarian headache. Am. J. Surg., 1929, n. ser., 7: 846. ------ Ovarian headache; report of a case of almost constant headache relieved during pregnancy and cured by hystero-oophorectomv. Tr. West. Surg. Ass. (1928) 1929, 38: 263-7.—Keith, D. Y. The value of radium in severe menstrual headache. Radiol. Rev., 1930 52: 128-31- Kelso. J. W. Gynecological headaches. J. Oklahoma M. Ass., 1933, 26: 245-7.—Martin, C. L. Menstrual headaches. Am. J. Roentg., 1930-31, 24: 267-79. ---— Radiation therapy in men.-t i ual headaches. Texas J. M., 1930- 31, 26: 280-3. Mar/otli. V. Emicrania mestruale. Clin. ostet., 1934, 36: 037 9. Mosher, (;. ('. Relation of headache to obstetrics and gynecology. J. Mi.--<>uri M. Ass., 1928, 25: 506-9.- Searight, M. W. The gynecologic aspect of headache. Memphis M. J., 1937, 12: 67. HEAD and neck. See also Ear, nose, and throat; Neck. Barn hill, J. F. Surgical anatomy of the head and neck. 921p. roy. 8? Bait., 1937. Also 2. ed. 773p. 26cm. 1940. Kampmeier, O. F. A manual of instruction of human morphology. Part VII: The morphology of the head and neck including neuro-anatomy. 194p. 8? Ann Arb., 1934. Pancoast, H. K., Pendergrass, E. P., & Schaeffer, J. P. The head and neck in Roentgen diagnosis. 976p. 26cm. Springf., 111. [1940] Reissinger, A. *Vergleichende Untersuchun- gen iiber den mikroskopischen Bau der arteriellen Blutgefasse des Kopfes und Halses der Haus- saugetiere [Bern] 60p. 8? Amorbach, 1904. Dixon, O. J. Research studies in visuaUzation of the vascular supply of the head and neck. Tr. Am. Acad. Ophth., 1934, 351-66.—Ferris, H. B. Anatomv of the head and neck; in two sections. In Pract. Libr. M. & S. (Appleton) N. Y., 1932, 1: 51-233.—Martin, H. E. A device for measuring diameters and the contours of cross-sections of the head and neck. Am. J. Roentg., 1931, 25: 536.—Surgical anatomy of the head and neck. Med. J. Australia, 1938, 2: 1039. ---- Actinomycosis. Freiwald, G. *Die Aktinomykose mit be- sonderer Berucksichtigung ihrer Aetiologie und der therapeutischen Resultate mit der kombi- nierten Jodkali-Rontgentherapie bei der cervico- facialen Form [Greifswald] 32p. 21cm. Lenge- rich, 1936. Krall, I. *Ueber Prognose, Verlauf und Be- handlung der Aktinomykose des Halses und des Kopfes [Heidelberg] 21p. 8? Wertheim, 1937. Krapf, H. *Die cervico-faciale Aktinomykose; ihre Behandlung und Prognose [Erlangen] 64p. 22cm. Elsfeld, 1938. Schwarz, K. *Die Rontgentherapie der Aktinomykose des Kopfes und des Halses [Bonn] 36p. 8? Diisseld., 1933. . Vollmering, K. *Erfolge mit der fraktionier- ten Rontgenbestrahlung bei der Aktinomykose cervico-facialer Lokalisation aus der Bestrah- lungsabteilung (leitender Oberarzt Dr Ewald) des Samariterhauses in Heidelberg (Direktor Professor Dr Kirschner) 20p. 8? Heidelb., 1934. Adair, J. H. Actinomycosis, with report of a case of the cervicofacial type. J. Minnesota M. Ass., 1908, 28: 365-9.— Canuyt, G., & Ruch. Un cas d'actinomycose cervico-faciale. Bull. Soc. pediat. Paris, 1935, 33: 308-10.—Cerbone, R. Osservazioni istologiche e patogenetiche a proposito di un caso di actinomicosi cervico-facciale. Med. lavoro, 1940, 31: 205; 227.—Chanial, G., & Rocher, P. Un cas d'actinomycose cervico- faciale. Bull. Soc. fr. derm, syph., 1939, 46: 919-22.—Cordeiro, H. Consideracoes sobre um caso curado de actinomic6se cervico-facial. Rev. brasil. otorinolar., 1940, 8: 635-50, pl.— Dubreuilh. Actinomycose cervico-faciale. J. med. Bordeaux, 1906, 36: 764.—Ferrando, M., & Ceruti, A. Su di un caso di micosi della regione cervicofacciale. Gior. batt. immun., 1938, 21: 393-400.—Ferrari. Actinomicosis cervico-facial. Bol. Soc. cir. B. Aires, 1939, 23: 26.—Gabourd. Actinomycose cervico- faciale gauche; actinomycose et grossesse. Lyon med., 1906, 106: 62-4.—Guinard, A. Actinomycose cervico-faciale chez un selUer. Bull. Soc. chir. Paris, 1906, n. ser., 32: 994-6.—Havens, F. Z. Actinomycosis of the head and neck. J. Am. Dent. Ass., 1933, 20: 478-80.—Helfenstein, A. Die zervikofaziale Aktino- mykose an der kantonalen Krankenanstalt in Aarau in den Jahren 1924-33 unter besonderer Berucksichtigung der Wechsel- beziehungen zwischen der anatomischen Lage der Infektions- pforte und den klinischen Initialsymptomen. Ausz. Inaugur. Diss. Med. Fak. Univ. Bern, 1933-35, No. 80, 1-4.—Ivy, R. H., & Curtis, L. Cervicofacial actinomycosis: a report of 2 cases. Dent. Cosmos, 1935, 77: 369-73.—Jorge. Tratamiento de la actinomicosis cervico-facial. Bol. Soc. cir. B. Aires, 1939 23: 8.—Langlet, L. Un cas d'actinomycose cervico-faciale. Union HEAD AND NECK 129 HEAD AND NECK med. nordest, 1906, 30: 141-4.—Le Fort. Actinomycose cervico-faciale. Echo med. nord, 1907, 11: 246.—MacFee, W. F. Actinomycosis of the head and neck with intracranial and pulmonarv metastases. Surg. Clin. N. America, 1932, 12: 427-34.—Montana™, J. C. E.. & Ferrari Hardoy, G. Actino- micosis cervicofacial; vacunoterapia. Rev. As. med. argent., 1937, 50: 655-61.—New, G. B., & Figi, F. A. Actinomycosis of the head and neck; a report of 107 cases. Surg. Gyn. Obst., 1923, 37: 617-25.—Nielsen, J. [Roentgen treatment of cervico- facial actinomycosis] Nord. med., 1939, 4: 3841.—Randall, O. S. Actinomycosis of the head and neck; pathology, diagnosis and treatment. J. Lancet, 1939, 59: 64-8.—Reclus, P. Sur une observation d'actinomycose cervico-faciale. Bull, med., Par., 1906, 20: 167.—Thiery, P. Le traitement de l'actino- mycose cervico-faciale. P. verb. Ass. fr. chir., 1905, 1137-9. ---- Cancer. Lehmann, A. *Beitrag zur Rontgen- und Radiumtherapie der Karzinome des Kopfes und der Halsorgane (unter besonderer Beriicksichti- gung der Ergebnisse der Chirurgischen Universi- tatsklinik Konigsberg der Jahre 1925-1930) [Konigsberg] 37p. 8? Deutsch-Eylau, 1931. Archer, V. W., & Hankins, W. D. Roentgen therapy of malignancv of the head and neck. J. Tennessee M. Ass., 1937, 30: 203-10.—Beck, J. C, rletzungen. 165p. 19}'cm. Miinch. [1938] Wki.tchek, H. *Craniocerebral injuries [S. Elizabeth Hosp.] 32p. 27cm. [Elizabeth, N. J.] 1940. Abbott. W. D. Head injuries. Nebraska M. J., 1932, 17: 54-8.- Adson, A. W. Head injuries. South. M. J., 1939, 32: 926-33. - - -- Cianieeeiel.ral injuries. J. Lancet, 1941,61: 4- 8.—Allen, L. Head injuries. N. England J. M., 1933, 209: 1011-4.—Andreasen, A. T. Head injuries. Ind. M. Gaz., 1937, 72: 552-8.—Biles, J. D., jr. Head injuries. Memphis M. J., 1933, 13: 152.— Boshes, B. Acute injuries to (he head. In Rev. med. Bos-hen, B.) Chic, 4. ed., 1940, 266-76 — Brennan, J. P. Aeule head injuries. Med. Rec, N. Y., 1936, 143: 523 6.- Hriusova, S. S. [Cranio-cerebral trauma] Vopr. neirokhu.. 19-1(1, 4: 55-72.—Bunten, W. A. Head injuries. J. Michigan M. S< c. I'.i3(). 29: 889-95.—Caldwell, J. A. Head injurieo. J. Med., (mem., 1930-31, 11: 628-33.—Cinelli, A. A. Head injury. E.\ <• Lai &c. Month., 1938-39, 17: 308 — Concilio, L. Traumatismos craneo-encefalicos. Ann. paul. med. cir., 1939, 38: 401-18.—Craig, W. McK. Head injuries. Minms.ua M.. 1931. 14: 131-4.—Dandv. W. E. Injuries to the head. Internal. .1. M. & S.. 1930. 43: 237 12. Also J. Lancet. 1932, 52: 1-5.—Dashkovsky, I. A. I Injuries of the skull and its content] Ortop. travmat.. 1940. 14: 29 36. Dickmann, H. Traumatismes craneo-eneei:ilie(». Dia med., B. Air., 1939, 11: 316.—Doolin, W. Recent head injuries. Irish J. M. Sc, 1930, li. ser., 497-507.—Dowman, C. E. Head injuries. South. M J., 1927, 20: 448-52.—Elvidge, A. R. Head injuries. Canad. M. Ass. J., 1938. 38: 26-33.— Geraghty, W. R. Head mimics West Viiginia M. J.. 1937. 33: 1-3.—Glass, R. L. Head injuries. .1. Indiana M. .Vs.. 1936. 29: 5(18-71 .—Gray, C. P., cte Gray, C. P., jr. Head injuiies. X. Orleans M. er., No. 105, 653-6.—Macdonald, H. E. Acute head injuiic- Maine M. J.. 1934, 25: 163 «.- Masland, R. L. Craiuocerebral trauma. In Cyclop. Med. (Piersol-Bortz) Phila., 1940, serv. vol.. 257-60 Mayfield, F. H. Acute head injuries. J. Med., Cinciu., 1938-39, 19: 126-30.—Mitchell, J. H. Craniocerebral injuries. Tri-tate M. J., 1940-41, 13: 2618-21. Also repr.- Moore, C. H. Head injuries. J. m! Ass. Alabama, 1938 39, 8: 7-12.- Neill. A. G. Head injuries. Nal. i:< lect. M. Ass. Q., 1939 10, 31: 30- '• Northliold. I>. W C. Ileail injuries. Practitioner, Lond.. 19 in, 115: II 53. Nuthall.A.W. Head injuries or intra-ci anial trauma Minninff. haul M. liev.. 1926, n. ser., I: 98-102 Palmer. L. A. Head injuries. Hosp. News, Wash., 1939, 6: No. 9, 15-21.- Pauliun, I)., Fortunescu, C. [ct al.] [On cranio-cerebral traumatism! Spitalul. 1938, 58: 453-60.—Pctrequin, J. K. Sur les eflets cruises dans le traumatisme du crane, d'apres I lippoerale et lea medecins de l'antiquite. Press - med. Pelce, 1867- 68. 20: 181.— PfafT, R. O. Head injuries. Med. J. & Pec. 1933. 137: 276- 8.— Phinnev, ('. Head injuries. J. Am. Osteopath. Ass., 1937- 38, 37: 197 563. Ramsey. E. B. Head injuries. J. Indiana M. Ass., 1938. 31: 332 1. Rhea. B. S. Wounds of the scalp and face. .1. Tennessee M. Ass., 1931, 24: 41. Risley, E. II. Traumatic head injuries. .Maine M. J., 1931, 22: 6-9 — Bitter, H. H. Head injuries. N. York State J. M., 1932, 32: 176.—Robertson, C. Head injuries. N. Zealand M. J., 1926- 27, 25: 49 55. Ross, J. P. Head injuries. S. Barth. Hosp. J., Lond., 1935 36. 43: 218-20.-- Rostock, P. Schadel, Hirn und Hirnhaute. In Handb. ses. Lnfallh. (F. Kdnig & G. Mapnu-t Stuttg., 1934, 4: 93-127.—Sachs, E. Head injuries. Internac. .1. M. & S., 1933, 46: 567-73. Also J. Lancet, 1938, 58: 513.—Summons, W. P. Head injuries. West Virginia M. ,L, 1938, 31: 162 9.—Sandler, S. A. Head injuiies. Hudson Co. Health Rec, 1936, 3: No. 4, 3 6- Semmes, R. E. Injuries to the head and brain. J. M. Ass. Ababama, 1934, 3: 231-4. ------ Head injuries. Mississippi Doctor, 1937-38, 15: No. 9,38-41. Sieber, P. R. Acute head traumas. West Virginia M. J., 1929, 25: 259--67. Slaughter, R. F. Craniocerebral trauma. .1. M. Ass. Ceoi-ia, 19 11, 30: II -9.- Swift, G. W. Cerebro-cranial injuries. Austral. N. Zealand J. Surg., 1938- 39, 8: 228-40.- Torkildsen. A. [Tiaumata capitis! Norsk. mas. laegevid., 1935, 96: 905-35.—Voris, H. C, Verbrugghen, A., A Reams, J. J. Head injuries. J. Am. M. Ass., 19-10, 115: 1765 71. Warren. J. N. Head injuries. J. Lancet, 1926, 46: 487--9. ■-Walerhouse, R. . Gaz., Lond., 1937, 43: 42-8.—Cervantes Zamorano, F. La traumatologfa craneo-encefaliea en Mexico. Rev. mid. veracruz., 1939, 19: 2836; passim.—Fay, T. Clinical con- siderations surrounding head injuries. Surg. Clin. N. America, 1931, 11: 1375-403.—Fraser, J. Head injuries in general practice. Brit. M. J., 1937, 1: 739-45—Hengstler, W. H. The neurological aspect of head injuiies. Minnesota M., 1931, 14:509-13. Also J. Lancet, 193,5,55:586 93.- Henninger. C. H. Symposium oni-eiious heel injuiies; neurologic considera- tions. Pennsylvania. M. J., 192,3,, 36: 756 8. -Johnson, L. W. & Hays, T. G. Sevce head iniunes. Hull. U. S. Navy Hep. Div. Prev. M., 1933, 31 : 2 11 53. Liiuion, L. Some aspects of head injuiies. Med. .1. Australia, 1040, 1: 299 302.—Mac- donald, H. E. Chronic head injuries; mild type. Maine M. J., 1936, 27: 97-9—McKissock, W., & Brownscombe, B. Appar- ently trivial head injuries. Lancet, Pond., 1941, 1: 593-5.— Miller, D. Some head injury problems. Med. J. Australia, 1937, 2: 466-70.—Moutet, F. ('onsidei ations pratiques sur les plaies de tete. Gaz. mild. Montpellier, 1852 53, 13: 1-16; 1853- 54, 14: 119; 145.—Pattison, A. R. D. Considerations on head injuries. Newcastle M. J., 1936, 16: 108-17.—Pope, V, Z. >e\ ere head injury. Postgrad. M. J., Pond., 1925-26, 1: 177.— Schuck, F. Some problems in head injuiies. N. York State J. M., 1937, 37: 1380 5.- Simpson, J. D. Slight head injury. PR. Nav. M. Serv., 1939, 25:26 9. Strauss, I., & Savitsky, N. Head injury; neurologic and psychiatric aspects. Arch. Neur. Psychiat., Chic, 1934, 31: 893-955. Torsegno, M. E. Osser- vazioni sui traumi cranio-c erel .iali. Note psichiat., Pesaro, 1938, 67: 381-411 .—Williams, L. S. Head injuries in general practice. S. Afr. M. J., 1936, 10: 833-5. ---- Compensation, and evaluation of dis- ability. Bohren, D. *Beitrajje zur Frage des erwerb- lichen Schicksals der Schudelverletzten [Zurich] 151p. 8? Affoltern a. Albis, 1936. Beaudoux, H. A. The medico-legal aspect of injuries to the head. J. Internat. Coll. Surgeons, 1910, 3: 449-59.—Carter, R. M. The determination of permanent disability following head injuries. Opera Internat. Congr. Indust. Accid. (1928) 1929, 5. Congr., 552-9.—Demme, H. Eiweissbefunde im Liquor von Schadeltraumatikern; ein Beitrag zur Frage der Begutachtung von Kopfverletzten. Med. Klin., BerL, 1930, 26: 590r2.—Esser, A. Die Bedeutung der pathologischen Ana.tom.ie bei traumatischen Hirnveranderungen fur die praktische Begutachtung lebender Kopfverletzter. Munch. med. Wschr., 1935, 82: 1164-6.—Firket, J. Quand faut-il admettre qu'un traumatisme est responsable d'une granulie? Ann. meU leg., 1936, 16: 401- 13.—Grabe, E. von. Beitrag HEAD INJURY 131 HEAD INJURY zur Frage der Begutachtung Kopfverletzter. Zschr. ges. Neur Psvchiat., 1930, 128: 615-28.—Hauert, D. Sozial- nolitische'Bemerkungen zur Frage der Kopf unfa lie. Nerven- arzt 1935 8: 576-80.—Horn, P. Zur Abfindungsfrage bei kop'fverlet'zten. Med. KUn.. Berl., 1932, 28: 1681-3- Kaufmann, C. Die Verletzungen des Kopfes. In his Handb. Unfallmed., 5. Aufl., Stuttg., 1932, 1: 339-67.—Ribeiro, L. Analise da tese de concurso sobre Traumatismos cranio- encefaUcos em medicina legal, do Dr Bourguy de Mendonca. Fol. med., Rio, 1940, 21 : 354-8.—Riggenbach, O. Beitrag zur Begutachtung psyehischer Storungen nach Kopftraumen. Schweiz. med. Wschr., 1930, 60: 989-91.—Schellworth, W. Zur Frage der gutachtlichen Beurteilung der Wiederher- stellung Unfallversichterter nach Kopftraumen. Deut. med. Wschr., 1938, 64: 1436-8.—Stevenson, W. O. Head injuries; a treatise on the pathologv, sequelae, and medico-legal aspects. Canad. M. Ass. J., 1938, 39: 522-7.—Stier. E. Wie kann der behandelnde Arzt die spatere Begutachtung von Kopfver- letzungen unterstutzen? Med. Welt, 1934, 8: 1190-3 — Vaccaro, L. Evaluation of head lesions. Indust. M., 1941, 10: 140-5.—Winkler, G., & Liebermann, H. Statistische Untersuchungen iiber den Muckschen Nasen-Adrenalin- Sondenversuch und dessen praktische Bedeutung fiir die Begutachtung von Kopfverletzungen. Deut. Zschr. Nervenh., 1932, 128: 253-69.—Zvaifler, N. Causes of error in the evalua- tion of disability following head injury. J. M. Soc. N. Jersey, 1933, 30:766. ---- Complication. Ehring, I. *Ein Fall von Encephalohydrocele traumatica. 15p. 21cm. Munster, 1936. Almeida Lima, & Imaginario, J. Tratamento dos acidentes tardios dos traumatismos cranio-encefalieos. Lisboa med., 1938 15- 733-82.—Cohen, I. Post-traumatic subdural hydr'oma. J. Mount Sinai Hosp. N. York, 1937-38, 4: 229- 36— Euziere, J.. Viallefont, H., & Vidal, J. Double atrophie optique et hemianopsie gauche consecutive k une blessure occipitale droite. Arch. Soc. sc. med. biol. Montpellier, 1933, 14: 212-5.—Grasso Biondi, I. Ricerche sperimentali sulle lesione e complicazioni dell'apparato respiratorio in seguito a traumi encefalici. Arch, antrop. crim., Tor., 1937, 57: suppl., 402-19.—Guerinot, A. J. Head injuries and ear disturbances. Laryngoscope, 1933, 43: 61-5.—Hallarman, H. A case of an injury to the head with compUcations. Med. Rec, N. Y., 1941, 154- 9-12.—Harwood, H. B. Some notes on the ear in rela- tion to head injury. Med. J. Australia, 1934, 1: 621-9 — Horrax, G. Head injuries and some of their complications. Am. J. Surg., 1932, 18: 1-15. Also repr.—Krebs, E. Du diagnostic et des indications operatoires dans les complications recentes et tardives des traumatismes cranio-c6rebraux fermes; 85 cas. Rev. neur., Par., 1939, 71: 369-88.—Love, J. G. Complications and sequelae of head injuries. Surg. Chn. N. America, 1938, 18: 1021-5.—Matveeva, D. N. [Trauma of the head and subsequent trauma of the ear and nosel Vest. otorinolar., 1939, No. 6, 26-33.—Meredith, J. M. The inci- dence and significance of shock in patients with acute head injuries, with special reference to the prevention of post- traumatic infections. Virginia M. Month., 1940, 67: 345-56.— Mock, H. E., & Takats, G. Hyperglycemia following head injuries; an experimental cUnical study. Ann. Surg. 1929, 90:190-201.—Moretti.E. Contributo alia conoscenza dell ema- toma cronico subdurale post-trauma+ico. Pensiero med., 1935, 24- 307-14, 3 pl.—Pilcher, C. The late complications of head injuries and their treatment. Mississippi Doctor, 1939-40 17- 236-40.—Rappoport, I. [Pathogenesis of cerebral hermaj Dnipropetr. med. J., 1928, 7: 169-72.—Seal, J. C. Ear, nose and throat involvement in head injuries. Med. J. & Kec, 1933, 137: 156-9. Also repr.—Schurr, C. G. Compression of the head, causing temporary sixth nerve paralysis. Brit. J. Ophth., 1930, 14: 231. ---- Diagnosis, and classification. Gross, S. W., & Ehrlich, W. Diagnosis and treatment of head injuries. 275p. 25cm. N. Y. [1940] Cheves H L The diagnosis and treatment of acute head injuries. J. M. Ass. Georgia, 1938, 27: 13-5.—Dickerson. D. G. Diagnosis of cerebral vascular accidents and other intracranial compUcations arising from trauma. J. Icwa M. Soc, 1934, 24: 132-6.—Diem. O. Zur Katamnese nach Kopt- verletzungen. Schweiz. Arch. Neur. Psychiat., 1933, 32: 18_26.—Faenza, M. Contributo clinico-statistico alio studio dei traumatism; cranio-cerebrali; progetto di una nviova classificazione dei traumatismi encefalici da violenza ottusa. Clin, chir., Milano, 1939, 42: 5-32.—Furlow, L. I\, & Sachs, E. Classification and treatment of acute head injuries. J. Missouri M. Ass., 1935, 32: 177-84.—Glaser, M. A., & Sjaardema, H The value of the electro-encephalogram in craniocerebral injuries. West. J. Surg., 1940, 48: 689-96.- Goland, P. P. Olfactometry in cases of acute head injury. Arch Surg., 1937, 35: 1173-82.—Hodgson, J. S. The diagnosis and treat- ment of craniocerebral injury. In Exp. Management Fract. (Wilson, P. D.) Phila., 1938, 443-51.—Hopkins C.W Head injuries, differential diagnosis and treatment. Med. Sentinel, 1928, 36: 807-10. Also J. Iowa M. Soc, 1931 21: oo2-5.— Kelman, H. The diagnosis and treatment of head injuries. Hosp. News, Wash., 1939, 6: No. 9, 21-33.—Kennedy, F. Head injuries: effects and their appraisal; evaluation of evi- dence. Tr. Am. Neur. Ass., 1931, 57: 383-7. Also Arch. Neur. Psychiat., Chic, 1932, 27: 811-5. Also repr.—Maass, J. La prueba de Queckenstedt unilateral en los traumatizados craneoencefalicos. Rev. mex. cir., 1938, 6: 209-71.—McCul- lough, C. J. Importance of visual-field studies after head injuries. Pennsylvania M. J., 1929-30, 33: 733-7.—Marrror, L, & Savitsky, N. Electroencephalographv in cases of head injury. Tr. Am. Neur. Ass., 1940, 66: 30-4.—Matveev, D. N. [Localization of injuries of the ear and nose in trauma of the head; microscopic examination] Vest, otorinolar., 1940, No. 10, 31-0.—Meredith, J. M. The diagnosis and treatment of acute head injuiies. Virginia M. Month., 1938, 65: 591-8.— Noto, G. G. Criteri diagnostici e curativi nei traumi cranio- cerebrali acuti. Rass. stud, psichiat., 1938, 27: 912-27 — Riddoch, G. Discussion on the diagnosis and treatment of acute head injuries. Proc R. Soc. M., Lond., 1932,25: 735-42 — Schreiber, F.. & Nielsen, A. Punch card code for classification of craniocerebral injuries. J. Michigan M. Soc, 1938, 37: 909-12.—Sinclair-I outit, K. W. C. Notes on the receiving- post classification of head injuries. S. Barth. Hosp. J., Lond., 1938-39, 46: 186-9.—Vogel. K. Erfahrungen mit dem Adrena- lin-Sondenversuch nach Muck. Zschr. Hals &c. Heilk., 1930-31, 28: 155-62.—7anello. D. La reazione di Donaggio nei traumi cranio-cerebrali. Riforma med., 1938, 54: 1635-8. ---- Forensic aspect. Hessemann, G. *Sur la medecine-legale des traumatismes de la region frontale. 43p. 8: Strasb., 1935. Lehmann, E. *Kopfverletzungen durch Ham- merschlage und ihre diagnostische Bewertung im Strafprozess [Munster] 16p. 22cm. Diis- seld., 1935. Muller, W. *T6tung durch Faustschlage auf den Kopf (mit einer kritischen Statistik uber Boxkampf-Todesfalle) [Munchen] 28p. 8? Murnau Obby, 1932. Wolf, F. *Die Zeugenaussagen Kopfver- letzter. 27p. 8? Bonn, 1927. Fedi, L. Intorno una ferita della testa succeduta da morte entro il settimo giorno. Ann. med. chir., Roma, 1842, 7: 277-82.—Fritz, E. Abreissung einer Arteria vertebralis von der Basilaris ohne Schsidelverletzung. Beitr. gerichtl. Med., 1935, 13: 22-7.—Harbitz, F. [Experiences in legal medicine with fatal injuries of the headl Norsk, mag. laegevid., 1934, 95- 353-86—Kappis, M. Ueber die todlichen Kopfverlet- zungen beim Boxkampf. Zbl. Chir., 1938, 65: 934-9—Kater- bau, G. Zur Beurteilung des Tatwerkzeuges bei einem Abhieb der Kopfschwarte. Deut. Zschr. gerichtl. Med., 1933, 21: 252-6.—Pette, H. Ueber zwei fur die Unfallpraxis wichtige Falle von Kopfverletzung mit todlichem Ausgang. Aerztl. Sachverst. Ztg, 1926, 32: 257-62.—Strassmann, G. Ueber Kopfverletzungen durch stumpfe Gewalt. Deut. Zschr. gerichtl. Med., 1930-31, 16: 327-40.—Viola. D. Giuoco del calcio e traumi cranici. Arch, antrop. crim., Milano, 1937, 57: 673-6. gunshot. Aronovich. G. D. [Rare case of bullet wound of the head] Vest khir , 1938, 55: 762-5.—Babchin, I. S. [Gun-shot wounds of the skull and brain] Sovet. med., 1940, 4: No. 20, 15-20 — Bls>ck, C. V. Gunshot wound of the head. J. Kansas M. Soc, 1938, 39: 464.—Cole, L. R., & Hodgson, E. R. Accidental gunshot wound of head with recovery; a case report. J. Lancet, 1940, 60: 124.—Diihlmann, H. Ueber seltene Schadelvarlet- zungen durch Platzpatronenschiisse. Deut. Militararzt, 1939, 4: 206-8.—Del Piano, J. L, Bergara, R. A., & Bergara, C. Fscopetazo sobre la region auricular y vecinas consideraciones. Rev. As. mid. argent., 1935, 49: 185-93.—Goode, J. V. Gun- shot wounds of the head; an analysis of 105 cases. Arch. Surg., 1934, 29: 16-22.—Jentzer, A. Traumatismes craniens et plaies cranio-c(?reT>rales par projectiles. Schweiz. med. Wschr., 1940, 70: 648; 667.—Moreau, L. Localisation d'une balle de revolver dans la tete. Bull. Soc. electroradiol. mid. France, 1939, 27: 682.—Nikarorov, V. A. [Clinical aspect, therapy and issue of gun shot wound in the head region of the horse] Sovet. vet., 1940, 17: No. 11, 71-5.—Reddingius [Gunshot wound of the head] Geneesk. tschr. Ned. Indie, 1937, 77: 1245.—Schuster, J. Ueber Encephalogramme von Kopf- schussverletzten. Arch. Psychiat., Berl., 1931, 93: 659-74.— Voris H. C. Gunshot wound of the head: report of a case. Arch. Neur. Psychiat., Chic, 1937, 38: 906. ---- gunshot: Complications and sequelae. Zerboni, I. v. *Ein Beitrag zur Kenntnis der Spat-Todesfalle nach Kopfschuss [Munchen] 27p. 8? Hamb., 1936. Cancella D'Abreau, A., & Saldanha, A. Migration mtra- cranio-rachidienne d'une balle de la voute au canal sacre\ HEAD 1NJIRY 1 Presse m6brales par projectiles. J. mid. chir., Par., 1940, 111: 87-91. ---- Instruments, and types of agents. Automobile accidents and head injuries. Week. Bull. Cali- fornia Dep. Pub. Health, 1935, 14: 85-7.—Giordano, D. Riflessioni sul caso di una sinistrata caduta >ul capo e portata comatosa in ospedale. Minerva med., Tor.. 1934, 25: 377 81).— Helpern, M. Unusual fatal stab wounds of head and neck with examples of unrecognized ice pick wounds of the brain". Am. ,1. Surg.. 1934. n. ser., 26: 53-63. Also repr.—Henry, A. T. Accidental perforation of the atlanto-occipital membrane. Ann. Clin. M., 1925-26, 32: 682-5—Jaso, J. \. Industrial accident: head split with electric drying fan. Am. J. Surg., 1935. 29: 458. - Junet. W. formes rares de traumatismes craiiio-cerebraux. Helvet. med. acta, 1938, 5: 818-21 — Muller. La difference entre les plaies du cuir chevelu par coups ile marteau et celles produites par choc de la tete contre un- piquet k ar£te vive et k section rectaugulaire. Echo med. nord, 1935, 3. ser., 4: 276-86.—Rippa, G. Lna singolare ferita da falce fienaia. Arch, antrop. crim., Milano, 1910, 60: 138- ll.-KizzaUi.E. Su di una ferita da giavel lotto al capo. Ibid 1937. 57: 1.77-82— Stevenson, W. O. Head injuries; a treat ise considering ihe accidents of the day. Canad. M. \" .1 1938 39: 338-47.—Tietze, A. Ueber stumpfe Ko, fvcrleUungeu Beitr. klin. Chir., 1926, 137: 523-610 [Discussion] 032-50.-- Wakeley, C. P. G. Head injurie- due to road accidents. Med. Press & Circ, Lond., 1934, 1K8: Suppl. Apr. 11, p. v-ix. ---- Manifestation. Ballantyne. A. J. Visual disturbances in cases of head injury. Tr. Med. Chir. Soc. Edinburgh, 1938-39, session 118, HEAD INJURY 94-102. Also Tr. R. Med. Chir. Soc. Glasgow, 1939, 33: 103- 12.—Cairns, H. The ocular manifestations of head injuiies. Tr. Ophth Soc. U. K., 1929, 49: 314 -52. Debernardi, I.. Un i unto doloroso alia prossione suH'angolo orbitario esterno come sintomn di lesione ossea nei traumi del capo. Arch. ital. chir., 193S, 51: 518-36.- Denny-Brown, D. Delayed collapse after head injury. Lancet, Lond., 1941, 1: 371-5.—Edwards, D. L. Ocular muscle imbalance following head injury. J. Oklahoma M. Ass., 1937, 30: 398-401. Eucri. C. ICmorragia endocranica tardiva da trauma. Rinasc med.. 1938. 15:87.— Gill, W. G. Eye symptoms in head injuiies. Med. Rec, Houston, 1931, 25: 676-81.—Giovannini, S. Le turbe del respiro nei traumatizzati ciauio-ceiebrali. Boll. Soc. ital. biol. sper., 1938, 13: 133, 3 ch. Criminal, E. Kopfunfall, Himer- schiitterung und Hirnverletzung. Praxis, Bern, 1938, 27: 411-4.—Hand, F. Ear manifestations following head injuries. California West. M., 1938,49: 42 -5. Kolik, M. E. [Nystagmus in acute trauma of the skull and luain] Vopr. neirokhir., 1939, 3: No. 5, 20-30.—Leoni Iparraguirre, C. A. Traumatismos craneo-encefalicosenla practica; si n< Ironies de los traumatizados craneo-encefalicos. Dia med., H. Air., 1939, 11: 614-21.— Mailing, K. Neurological symptoms from trauma capitis. Acta psychiat. neur., Kbh., 1933, 8: 39-67. Montana™, .1. C, Franchini, V., it Saladini. A. Faralisis facial, otorrea cronica y traumatisme Sem. med., H. Air., 1939, 46: pt 2, 1135-7.— Pick, B. P. A case of head injury with few clinical signs. J. R. Nav. M. Serv., 1933, 19: 184.—Symonds, C. P. The assessment of symptoms following head injury. Guy's Hosp. Gaz., Lond., 19.37, 51: 461-8.—Tanturri, V. Oonsiderazioni sulle lesioni auiicolan dovute a traumi del capo. Pass. ital. otorinolar., 4: 53 63.--Thomas, H. V. Head injuiies; extra- globar factors influencing vision. West "Virginia M. .)., 1941, 37: 399-402.—Visen, E. M. [Material for studv of sympto- matology of trauma of the head] Vrach. delo, 1937, i9: 99- 104.—Vogel, K. Hals, Nase, Ohren und Unfall. Mschr. Unfallh., 1935, 42: 433 19.—Wolchman, W. Some head injuries and their features. .1. M. Ass. S. Africa., 1930, 4: 747- 54.—Woodhall, B. Acute head injuries; with particular reference to temperature, pulse and respiration curves. Vir- ginia M. Month., 1938, 65: 413-8. ---- Manifestation, mental. Berner, 0. Hvor liten kan den 0ieblikkelige funksjonsforstyrrelse i hjernen vaere efter en stor hodeskiide? 36p. 27cm. Oslo, 1938. Also Norsk mag. laegevid., 1938, 99: [Forh. Norsk, med. selsk.] 190-4. Conkey, R. C. Psychological changes asso- ciated with head injuries. 62p. 8? N. Y., 1938. Del Portello. R. El sindrome apitico de Allers. Siglo m6d., 1935, 96: 186-9.—Guttmann, E., & Winterstein, C. E. Dis- turbances of consciousness after head injuries; observations on boxers. J. Ment. Sc, Lond., 1938, 84: 347-51.—Krebs, E., & Puech, P. Traumatisme cranio-ceLebral et troubles mentaux. Rev. neur., Par., 1939, 72: 63-6.—Mapother, E. Mental symptoms associated with head injury; the psychiatric aspect. Brit. M. J., 1937, 2: 1055-61.—Martin, J. P. Mental symptoms associated with head injury; the neurological aspect. Ibid., 1061-4. Also Ulster M. J., 1937, 6: 240-5.—Northfield, D. W. C. Delirium and coma in head injuries. Med. Press & Circ, Lond., 1940, 203: 433-0 — Parke?, R. Q. The causes of loss of consciousness following acute head injury, and their relation to the treatment of this condition. Roy. Berkshire Hosp. Rep., 1934-35, 148-59.—Rogers, L. Mental effects of head injury. Brit. M. J., 1937, 2: 282-4— Schachter, M. La carphologie sexuelle. J. med. Paris, 1939, 59: 711.—Verjaal, A. Amnesie nach Trauma capitis. Zschr. ges. Neur. Psychiat., 1939, 166: 221-35. ---- Military aspect. Alexander, R. C. Treatment of head injuries in war. Brit. M. J., 1940, 2: 65.—Baumgartner. Les plaies cranio-ceLebrales et leur traitement en chirurgie de guerre. Vjschr. schweiz. SanitatsofL, 1941, 18: 27-30—Briesen, H. V. A head injury ■survey; etiology and prevention. U. S. Nav. M. Bull., 1940, 38: 483-93.—Cairns, H. Treatment of head injuries in war. Brit. M. J., 1940, 1: 1029. Also repr.—Cuadrado, F. Re- sultados inmediatos en heridas craneo-cerebrales de guerra. Rev. espan. med. cir. guerra, 1940, 5: 203-20.—D'Arcy, T. N. On head injuries. J. H. Nav. M. Serv., 1939, 25: 20-6 — David, M., & Ferey, D. Sur l'activite du Centre neurc- chirurgical de la II. armee; k propos du traitement des blessures cranio-cerebrales. Presse med., 1940, 48: 868.— Decker, P., & Rossier, J. Les plaies cranio-cerebrales en chirurgie de guerre. Rev. m6d. Suisse rom.. 1940, 60: 321-56.- Dott. N. 1VL The management of head injuries. In War & Doctor (Mackintosh, J. M.) 2. ed., Lond., 1940, 89-98. ------- Injuries of the brain and skull. In Surg. Modern Warf. (Bailey, H.) Edinb., 1940- >H:,6r83~~710-~~ Hanson, A. M. War time injuries of the head. Mil. Surgeon, 1927, 61 : 21-30.—Hill. I). Head injury and war neurons. Med. Piess & Circ, Lend., 1941, 205:' 140-3.— Jackfon, H. Head injuries in wai. Postgrad. M. J., Lond., 1940, 16: 221-32.—Jefferson, G. War wounds of the head. Brit. M. J., 1939, 2: 347; 407.—Johnson, L. W. Treatmentof head injuries. U. S. Nav. M. Bull., 1931, 29: 592-8.—Lock- HEAD INJURY wood, A. L. Head wounds (surgical problems of war) Brit. M. J., 1940, 1: 445-7.—Loreti, M., & Zanetti, S. Osservazioni di feriti cranio-cerebrali nei ccnfliUo Italo-Etiopico. Clinica, Bologna, 1936, 2: 324-31.—Money, R. A. War wounds of the head. Med. J. Australia, 1940, 1: 443-6.—Morsier, G. de. Les traumatisme cranio-ceLebraux k l'arme'e; frequence des arachnoidites opto-chiasmatiques; necessity d'un repos prolonge. Rev. med. Suisse rom., 1940, 60: 1014.—Naegeli, T. Ueber Kriegskopfverletzungen. Schweiz. med. Wschr., 1940, 70: 817-9.—Ostrovsky, M. I. [On hidden trauma of the skull and brain in war] Sovet. vrach. J., 1939, 42: 495-9.—Roger?, L. The management of cases of head injury. J. R. Nav. M. Serv., 1935, 21: 2-8.—Rouvillois, Duval, P. [et al.] A propcs du traitement des plaies de guerre cranio-cere-brales. Mem. Acad. chir., Par., 1939, 65: 1052-70.—Schrader, G. Zur Begutach- tung plotzlicher Spattodesfalle nach Kopfverletzungen im Weltkriege. Mschr. Unfallh., 1941, 48: 161-71.—Schultz, L H. Gehirn und Geschlechtsdriise; Sexualverhalten von Kriegs- kopfverletzten. Med. Welt, 1927, 1: 792.—Smith, G. W. The diagnosis and treatment of head injuries. U. S. Nav. M. Bull., 1940, 38: 447-72, pl.—Symonds, C. P. Closed head injuries. J. R. Army M. Corps, 1941, 76: 320-9.------it Jefferpon, G. The treatment of head injuries. J. R. Nav. M. Serv., 1936, 22: 23-32.—Treatment of craniocerebral war wounds. J. Am. M. Ass., 1939, 113: 1890.—Willway, F. W. Head injuries in war- time. Bristol Med. Chir. J., 1940, 57: 91-8. Also- Clin. J., Lond., 1940, 69: 290-5.—Wounds of the head. J. Am. M. Ass., 1941, 117: 632. --- Pathology. Gennerich, K. *Ueber die pathologische Bedeutung und iiber die Beziehung der Dip- loevenen zum Kopftrauma und zu dessen Folgen [Kiel] 20p. 221/2cm. Hamb., 1937. Rolleri, T. T. *Acute craniocerebral injuries; their mechanisms and their management. 38p. MS. 4? Sacramento, 1938. Behrend, C. M. Ueber traumatische Hirnschaden bei unverletzter Schadelkapsel. Med. Welt, 19?-6, 10: 1472-4 — Gierlich, J. Veranderungen am Ependym und den subependy- maren Zonen des Gehirns bei frischen stumpfen Kopfverlet- zungen. Deut. ZmIit. gerichtl. Med., 1936, 26: 100-29 — Gorodizhskaia, G. L, it Milotvorskaia, L. I. Influence du traume mecanique de la tete sur le gonflement des colloldes du cerveau. Bull, biol med. exp. URRS, 1937, 4: 79.—Linell.E. A. The types of intracranial haemorrhage caused bv head injury. Univ. Toronto M. J., 1940-41, 18: 113-7.—Patel, J. Les lesions traumatiques cranio-encephaliques r^centes. In Precis path, chir., 6. ed., Par., 1938, 2: 16-50.—Pilcher, C. Experi- mental cerebral trauma; the fluid content of the brain after trauma to the head. Arch. Surg., 1937, 35: 512-27.—Rand, C. W., & Courville, C. B. Histologic studies of the brain in cases of fatal injury to the head. Ibfd., 1931, 23: 357-425. Also repr. ------ Reaction of the classic neuroglia. Arch. Neur. Psychiat., Chic, 1932, 27: 1342-79. ------ Histologic changes in the brain in cases of fatal injurv to the head; changes in the nerve fibers. Ibid., 1934, 31: 527; 1936, 36: 1277 — Rogers, L. Concussion and compression. Brit. M. J., 1938, 1: 743-5.—Rossier, J. Contribution k 1'eLude des traumatismes cranio-cereLraux. Rev. med. Suisse rom., 1936, 56: 830-56. ------ Contribution k 1'eLude des traumatismes cranio- cereLiraux; pathologie de l'espace sous-dural. J. chir., Par., 1939, 53: 625-49.—Shapiro, P.. & Jackson. H. Swelling of the brain in cases of injury to the head. Arch. Surg., 1939, 38: 443-56.—Stevenson, L. D. Head injuries: effects and their appraisal; the role of the microglia. Tr. Am. Neur. Ass., 1931, 57: 356-62. Also Arch. Neur. Psychiat., Chic, 1932, 27: 784- 90. Also repr.—Worti?, S. B. Head injuries: effects and their appraisal; experimental studies of induced convulsions and ventricular distortion in the cat. Tr. Am. Neur. Ass., 1931, 57: 348-55. Also Arch. Neur. Psychiat., Chic, 1932, 27: 776-83. Also repr.------ & McCulloch, W. S. Head injuries; an experimental study. Arch. Surg., 1932, 25: 529. Also repr. ---- Pathophysiology. Bielschowsky [XL] P. [W.] *Storungen des Liquorsystems bei Kopfverletzten [Breslau] p.55-117. 8? Berk, 1928. Also in Zschr. ges. Neur. Psychiat., 1928, 117: Chavira.R. A. La tensi6n de la arteria central de la retina en los traumatismos craneo-encefalicos. An. Soc. mex. oft., 1939, 14: 209-36. Also Gac med. Mexico, 1940, 70: 209-40 — Effect on head wounds of transportation by air. J. Am. M. Ass., 1939, 113: 1823.—Electroencephalographic changes in head in juries. Ibid., 1941, 117: 876.—Gurdjian, E. S., Webster. J. E., & Sprunk, C. J. Studies of the spinal fluid in cases of injury to the head; effects of drainage, isotonic fluids, morphine and soluble phenobarbital U. S. P. on cerebrospinal fluid pres- sure. Arch. Neur. Psychiat., Chic, 1939, 42: 92-111 — Jasper, H. H., Kershman, J., & Elvidge, A. Electroencephalo- graphic studies of injurv to the head. Ibid., 1940,44:328-50.— Kiihne, W. Die Reaktion des Gehirns auf Kopfverletzungen. Mschr. Unfallh., 1934, 41: 121-9.—Petrov, I. R., & Goncharov, P. P. [Effect of lowered pressure on animals with injuries of HEAD INJURY the skull and brain] Tr. Acad. mil. med. Kiroff, 1935, 3: 157 67.—Schreiber, F. Cerebral anoxia and craniocerebral injuries. J. Michigan M. Soc, 1941, 40: 603-6.—Stier, E. Kopftrauma und Hirnstamm. Arch. Psychiat., BerL, 1936-37, 106: 351- 406.—Williams, D. Electroencephalographic changes in head injuries. Lancet, Lond., 1941, 2: 11.—Zierold, A. A. Intra- cranial pressure in head injuries. Arch. Surg., 1935, 31: 823-32. ---- Radiography. Kohlmann, L. *Beitrag zur Frage des En- cephalogramms der Schadeltraumatiker [Greifs- wald] 16p. 8? Peine, 1936. Browder, J. Head injuries, with special reference to the value of cerebral aerography in diagnosis and treatment. Surg. Clin. N. America, 1941, 21: 311-21.—Friedman, E. D. Head injuries: effects and their appraisal; encephalography observa- tions. Tr. Am. Neur. Ass., 1931, 57: 363-82. Also Arch. Neur. Psychiat., Chic, 1932, 27: 791-810. Also repr.— Rogers, L. The importance of X-raying cases of head injury. J. R. Nav. M. Serv., 1933, 19: 171-3.—Schiiller, A. Rontgen- befunde bei Verletzungen des Kopfes. Wien. klin. Wschr., 1929, 42: 560. ------ X-ray examination in recent head injuiies. Med. J. Australia, 1941, 1: 641.—Tarrura, Y. Ueber das Enoephalogramm des Kopftraumatikers. Psychiat. neur. jap., 1935, 39: 17.—Traverp, J. T. Roentgenologic findings of post-traumatic sequelae of head injuries: an encephalographic study. Radiology, 1937, 28: 704-13.—Vulpius, O. Ein trugerisches Rontgenbild. Mschr. Unfallh., 1926, 33: 18. ---- Sequelae. Hock, T. *Ueber die Bedeutung von Kopf- traumen (mit Gehirnerschiitterung) fiir die Entstehung essentieller Hypertonien. 43p. 8? Bonn, 1929. Martineau, J. E. *Head injuries and their sequelao; a review of recent literature [Mil- waukee Co. Hosp.] 45 1. 28cm. [Wauwatosa] 1939. Ritter, G. *Ueber doppelseitige reflek- torische Pupillenstarre nach Sohadeltraumen. 27p. 21cm. Bonn, 1937. Uhde, H. H. *Der Einfluss von Kopf- traumen auf die Entstehung oder Verschlim- merung von Arteriosklerose und damit auf das Gehororgan. 17p. 8° Frankf. [1936] Bernstein, V. S., & Shimanovich, S. V. [Injuries of the skull and their remote sequels; treatment] Ortop. travmat., 1938, 12: 28-35.—Bing, R. Sequelae after trauma capitis as illustrated in a material of 39 patients. Acta psychiat. neur., Kbh., 1933, 8: 105-16.—Brandis. W. Angeblich langdauernde Folge einer Kopfverletzung. Med. Klin., Berl., 1928, 24: 1281.—Bregman, Zamenhof & Lipszowicz. Alterations oculaires k la suite de traumatismes graves de la ttHe. Rev. neur., Par., 1933, 40: pt 2, 480.— Bulynin, I. N. [Trauma of the head; its sequels and treatment] Nov. khir. arkh., 1938, 42: 363-9.—Camp, W. E. Visual-field contractions after head injury. Am. J. Ophth., 1937, 3. ser., 20: 304— Cathcart, J. P. S. Effects of head trauma; patients should be impressed with the idea that they will recover fully in a certain time. Nat. Health Rev., Ottawa, 1940, 8: 39.—David, M., Krebs, E., & Trotot, R. A propos du traitement chirurgical de cer- taines se'quelles des traumatismes cranio-c^reLraux. Gaz. mid. France, 1938, 45: 155-61.—Douglas, J. C. Blindness following head injury. Med. J. Australia, 1938, 1: 534.— Eckel, J. L. The aftermath of head injuries. N. York State J. M., 1928, 28: 771-7.—Garland, H. G. The after-effects of head injury. Clin. J., Lond., 1939, 68: 56-60.—Gleckler, J. D. Certain late effects of head injuries. Texas J. M., 1938-39, 34: 356-60.—Grant, H. W. Visual field contractions after head injury. Minnesota M., 1936, 19: 449-54.—Greenwood, J., jr. Follow-up on craniocerebral injuries. South. M. J., 1940, 33: 1077-81.—Haenel, H. Zur Behandlung der Folgen von Kopfverletzungen. Psychiat. neur. Wschr., 1938, 40: 45-7.—Hengstler, W. H. The remote effects of head injury. Minnesota M., 1932, 15: 163-7.—Hohlen, K. S. J. Late results of head injuries. Nebraska M. J., 1937, 22: 12-4 — Hiiskes. I. Beitrage zu den Unfallfolgen von versicherten und unversicherten Schadelhirnverletzten. Mschr. Unfallh., 1939, 46: 213.—Hulbert, H. S. Observations on sequels of head injury, especially in children. Indust. M., 1937, 6: 485-8.— Julliard, C. L'accoutumance aux s^quelles des traumatismes encdphaliques; son mecanisme. Rev. m<§d. Suisse rom., 1937, 57: 385—104.— Lang, I. [Posttraumatic calcification of sub- dural space] Orv. hetil., 1937, 81: 708.—Laurie, W. S. An unusual result of head injury. Med. J. Australia, 1938, 1: 19.—LeFever, H. E. A consideration of the late effect of head injuries. Ohio M. J., 1933, 29: 493-6.—Lemke, R. Ueber einige Spatfolgen nach Kopfverletzung. Munch, med. Wschr., 1938, 85: 1663-5.—McConnell, A. A. Sequelae of minor head injuries. Irish J. M. Sc, 1926, 6. ser., 29-34.—Malbran, J. Deficit visual bilateral por traumatismo frontal. Rev. As. mid. argent., 1936, 50: 287-91.—Naville, Franceschetti <&; HEAD INJURY 134 HEAD INJURY Bichler. D. Accomodotonie posttraumatique. Praxis, Bern. 19 10, 29: 666.- Pajak, J. [Re-education and mental hygiene in post-traumatic conditions of the skull] Rocz. psychiat, 1938, 31: 157-85.—Patel, J. Les complications secondaire* et Its suites 61oignees des divers traumatismes cranio-encepha- liques. In Precis path, chir., 6. ed., (P. Begouin, H. Bourgeois [et al.] 1'ar.. 1938, 2: 57-69.- Pfingst, A. O. Unilateral blind- ness result of blow on head. Kentucky M. J., 1933, 31: 81 — Quensel. F. Ueber die Sp-itfolgen der Kopfverletzungen und due Behandlung. -Med. Welt, 1933, 7: 1243-6.—Raaf, J. The treatment of the late effects of head injuries. Proc. Cong:. Panpacific Surg. Ass., 1939, 347-56, pl.—Rowbotham, (;. F. Complications and sequels of injuries to the head. Med. Press & Circ, Lond., 1941, 205: 379-84.—Russell, W. R. The after-effects of head injury. Tr. Med. Chir. Soc. Edin- burgh, 1933-34, 113. session, 129-44. ------ Late effects of head iniurv. Ibid.. 1938-39, 118. session, 88-93. Also Tr. R. Med. Chir. Soc. Glasgow, 1939, 33: 97-102.—Sahs, A. L. Sequelae of head injuries. J. Iowa M. Soc, 1936, 26: 286-8.- Schaltenbrand, G. Ueber Folgezustande von stum- pfen Kopfverletzungen. Med. Klin., Berl., 1934, 30: 1381-77 — Smith, A. E. Impairment of vision following head injury. Minnesota M., 1931, 14: 809-19.—Slier, E. Was lehren uns die von I'ietruskv mitgeteilten Selbstberichte iiber Folgen von Ko] itraumeiC Mschr. Unfallh., 1938, 45: 428-36.—Strauss, I.. A- Savitsky, N. The sequelae of head injury. N. York State J. M., 1937, 37: 1181- 8.—Symonds, C. P. Some late effects of head injuries. Guy's Hosp. Gaz., Lond., 1927, 41: 342-6. Also Clin. J., Lond., 1928, 57: 445-9.—Wakeley, C. P. G. The remote effects of head injurv. Med. Press & Circ., I.ond.. 1927, n. ser., 124: 169- 71— Wechsler, I. S. The complications and sequels; of head injuiies. Bull. Menninger Clin., 1936, 1: 10-8.—Winther, K. The retinal arterial pressure in sequel r after trauma capitis. Acta psychiat. neur., Kbh., 1933, 8: 87-96. ---- Sequelae, mental and neural. Allen, I. M. The immediate and remote effects of minor lc-ions of ilc cervical portion of the spinal cord following head injur;-. Austral. N. Zealand J. Surg., 1940-41, 10: 157-72 — Anglade & Anglade, R. Sur quelques signes dits fonctionnels, dans les syndromes post-traumatiques. Rev. otoneur., Par.. 1937, 15: 112—Bakay, L.. Benedek, L., & Kulcsar, F. [Menin- gioma following head injury] Gy6gyaszat, 1938, 78: 424-8.— Benedek, L., rv. hetil., 1939, 83: 149-51, pl.— Benton, A. L., & Howell. I. I,. The use of psychological tests in the evaluation of intellectual function following head injurv; report of a case of post-traumatic personality disorder. Psychosomat. M., 1941, 3: 138-51.—Bentsen, P. G. [Cases of bead trauma with predominant mental disorders] Hos- pitalstidende, 1930, 79: Neur. selsk. forh., 32.—Bowman, K. M., ., & Sigwald, J. A propos d'un cas d'hydro- pisie subdurale posttraumatique, manifesto 5 mois apres ['accident. Rev. neur., Par., 1937, 67: 224-7.—Pilkington, F. The treatment of the mental after-effects of head injury. Irish J. M. Sc, 1937, ser. 6, 742-5.—Psychiatric sequels of head injuries. J. Am. M. Ass., 1938, 111: 2503.—Psychological terms used in cases of head injury- Brit. M. J., 1941, 1: 525.— Puec, P. Des meningites seicuses et arachnoidites dans les traumatismes cranio-encephaliques. Bull. m£d., Par., 1939, 53: 485-92.—Reiter, P. J. Mental disturbances after trauma capitis. Acta psychiat. neur., Kbh., 1933, 8: 101 -3.—Roussct, S., Daumezon, G., & Masson, J. Doinenco traumatique; reactions revendicatrices inddpendantes dn prejudice. Ann. med. psychol., Par., 1938, 96: ] 16-22.- Savitsky, N. further comments on head injury: the postconcussion syndrome. N. York State J. M., 1934, 34: 909-14.—Schaller, W. F. After-effects of head injury; the post-traumatic concussion state (concussion, traumatic encephalopathy) and the post- traumatic psychoneurotic state (psychoneurosis, hysteria) a study in differential diagnosis. J. Am. M. Ass., 1939, 113: 1779-85.—Schilder, P. Psychic disturbances after head injuries. Am. J. Psychiat., 1934, 90: 155-88.—Schneider, K. 1'sy chosen nach Kopfverletzungen. Nervenarzt, 1935, 8: 567-73.- Shapiro. L. B. Schizophrenic-like psychosis following head injuries. Illinois M. J., 1939, 76: 250-4.— Steinberg, I). L. Psychotic reaction following trauma. Ibid., 246-50.— Strauss, I., & Savitsky, N. The sequelae of head injury; the psychogenic factor. Am. J. Psychiat., 1934, 90: 189-202.— Symonds, G. P. Observations on the differential diagnosis and treatment of cerebral states consequent upon head in- juries. Brit. M. J., 1928, 2: 829-32. ------ Mental disorder following head injury. Proc R. Soc. M., Lond., 1936-37, 30: 1081-94. Also Clin. J., Lond., 1937, 66: 397-406.—Urechia, C. I., & Elekes, N. Meniugite sereuse et acces d'dpilepsie apres des coups sur la teTe. Bull. Soc. mid. hop. Paris, 1933, 3. ser., 49: 579.—Wechsler, I. S. Trauma and the nervous system, with special reference to head injuries and a classi- fication of post-traumatic syndromes (analysis of 100 cases) J. Am. M. Ass., 1935, 104: 519-26.—Wolfson, I. N. Psy- chiatric aspect of head injuries. Psychiat. Q., 1938, 12: 137-75. ---- Sequelae, vestibular. Barth, H. Die Begutachtung des Kopftraumas in der Ohrenheilkunde. Chirurg, 1934, 6: 715-22.—Baumoel, S., & Marks, M. I. Evaluation of vertigo following head injuries. Arch. Otolar., Chic, 1941, 33: 204-15.—Beyer, H. Vestibu- laris- und Augenmuskelstorungen nach Kopfverletzungen. Zschr. Hals &c Heilk., 1936-37, 41: 281-6.—Eliasberg, W. Begutachtung von Kopftraumen unter Verwertung otologischer Befunde. Med. Welt, 1927, 1: 1739-41.— Glaser, M. A. The cause of dizziness in head injuries: a vestibular test study in 66 patients. Ann. Otol. Rhinol., 1937, 46: 387-408.—Grove, W. E. Otological findings in head trauma; a clinical study based upon 42 cases. Tr. Am. Lar. Rhin. Otol. Soc, 1928, 34: 151-207. Also Arch. Otolar.. Chic, 1928.8: 249-99.—Kisch, H., Kelemen, G. [et al.] Disturbances of function of the ear following injury. Lancet, Lond., 1936, 1: 660.—Mackenzie, G. W. Are the vestibular tests reliable in the diagnosis of head injury? Eye Ear &c. Month., 1929, 8: 103-5.—Murphy, A. B. Evaluation of vertigo following head injuries. Northwest M., 1933, 32: 25-8.—Mygind, S. H. Injuries of the head; oto-neurological parallelisms. Acta psychiat. neur., Kbh., 1933, 8: 97-100 — Northington, P. Functional ear damage in head injuries. Surg. Clin. N. America, 1941, 21: 357-66.—Rhese, H. Be- gutachtungen nach Kopftraumen unter Verwertung otologischer Untersuchungsmethoden. Med. Welt, 1927, 1: 1476-9.— Stier, E. Kopfverletzungen und Schwindel. Arch, orthop. I niallehir., 1933-34, 34: 208-16. ------ Die Bedeutung der Lnteisin hung des Gleichgewichtsapparates fiir die Begutach- tung alter Kopfverletzungen. Mschr. Unfallh., 1934, 41: 385-95. ------ Ueber die Deutung der nach Kopfverletzun- gen nachweisbaren vestibuliiren Symptome. Ibid., 1935, 42: 481-8. ------ Welche Schlusse konnen wir bei der Begutach- tung von Kopfverletzungsfolgen aus den Ergebnissen der Untersuchung des Gleichgewichtsariparates heute schon Ziehen? Deut. med. Wschr., 1936, 62: 476; 519. ------ Ueber die Deutung der nach Kopfverletzungen nachweisbaren yestibularen Symptome. Deut. Zschr. Nervenh., 1936, 139: tSo^2' ------ Schwindel nach Kopftrauma. Nervenarzt, 1937, 10: .5o4-7. —----■ Zur Begutachtung des Schwindels nach Kopftrauma. Zschr. ges. Neur. Psychiat., 1938 161: 401. -—— Ueber die Mithilfe des Ohrenarztes bei der neurologischen Begutachtung der Folgen von Kopftraumen. HEAD INJURY 135 HEAD INJURY Ibid., 1939, 165: 223.—Van Poole, G. McD. Head injuries from the otologist's standpoint. Tr. Hawaii M. Ass., 1934, No. 44, 23-7. Also repr.—Zacks, M. A. Importance of vestibular findings following injury to the head. Arch. Otolar., Chic, 1939, 30: 601-14. ---- Statistics, and cases. Battle, N. P. Traumatic injuries to the head; a study of 200 consecutive cases. Am. J. Surg., 1939, 43: 66-72.—Bester, F. P. An interesting head injury. S. Afr. M. J., 1936, 10: 95.— Bevan, A. D. Two cases of head injury. Surg. Clin. N. America, 1927, 7: 481-8.—Briesen, H. V. A head injurv survey. Surg. Gyn. Obst., 1940, 71: 633-42— Carelli, A. Un caso poco frecuente. Sem. mid., B. Air., 1936, 43: 1394.— D'Arey, T. N. A case of severe head injury. J. R. Nav. M. Serv., 1936, 22: 242-4.—Fuller, C. K. An unusual head injurv. Canad. M. Ass. J., 1938, 39: 61-3.—Gotten, N. Head trauma; report of 141 cases. J. Am. M. Ass., 1938, 110: 1727-30.—Jianu, A., & Enesco, C. Considerations sur 3 cas de traumatismes cranio- ceVeLireux. Rev. chir., Bucur., 1940, 43: 375-8.—Lechner, H. Kommotionen, Kontusionen, Kompressionen und Schadel- frakturen; Bericht uber 1149 Falle. Zbl. Chir., 1939, 66: 616- 23.—Malago, P. P. Storia di un caso gravissimo e singolare osservato nella clinica chirurgica all'Arcispedale di S. Anna di Ferrara. Gior. progr. pat., Venez., 1840, 14: 349-82.—Meny- hard, I. [Experience gained from 589 cases of cranial and cerebral injuries] Oryostud. kozl., 1941, 2: 25-8.—Meredith, J. M. Unusual head injuries; with a report of 5 cases. South. M. J., 1940, 33: 703-10.—Pickles, W. Head injuries; observa- tions based on a study of 554 patients. Tr. N. England Surg. Soc, 1940, 23: 45-56. Also N. England J. M., 1941, 224: 139- 42.—Rizzo, F. P. A report of 3 cases of head injuries. Tri- state M. J., 1934, 6: 1299-303.—Sartorius. K. A study of 100 cases of head injury. S. Afr. M. J., 1939, 13: 1-9.— Schiick, F. Kopfverletzungen; Bericht iiber 300 Falle. Arch. klin. Chir., 1928, 153: 77-93.—Skoog. T. Studies of a material of head- injuries from the surgical clinic in Lund, with special reference to the temporal bone involvement. Acta chir. scand., 1935-36, 77: 383-451.—Spessard, T. N. Some observations in 80 cases of head injury. Virginia M. Month., 1937-38, 64: 334-6 — Swift, G. W. Head injuries of moderate degree; a review of 100 cases, including 50 ventricular studies. Northwest M., 1931, 30: 16-9. Also Surg. Gyn. Obst., 1931, 52: 576-8. -----& Berens,S.N. Cerebrocranial injuries; detailed study of 1,433 cases. J. Am. M. Ass.. 1938, 111: 1448-52.—Torkildsen, A. A report on 472 cases of head injury treated in the Roya Victoria Hospital, Montreal. Acta psychiat. neur., Kbh., 1935, 10: 643-55.—Weaver, J. C. The anthropology of the Negro, its bearing on the mortality in head injuries: a review of 600 cases. Surg. Gyn. Obst., 1930, 50: 499-502—Wortis, S. B., & Kennedy, F. Acute head injury; a study of 1,000 cases. Ibid., 1932, 55: 365. ---- Surgery. Abbott, W. D. Surgical treatment of head injuries. J. Iowa M. Soc, 1937, 27: 183-7.—Abramson, P. D. Injuries of the head. Am. J. Surg., 1931, n. ser., 13: 47-55. Also repr.— Andreoletti, G. Sulle lesioni traumatiche cranio-cerebrali. Arch. ital. chir., 1938, 50: 68-71.—Bates, C. O. Treatment of acute head injuries. South. Surgeon, 1936, 5: 343-7.—Berens, S. N. Head injuries. West. J. Surg., 1936, 44: 624-35 — Binion, R. Surgical management of head injuries. Indust. M., 1938, 7: 178.—Briesen, H. v., & Jones, E. M. New opera- tion for relief of increased intracranial pressure in head injuries; case report. Am. J. Surg., 1940, 50: 126-9.—Brown, J. A. Some indications for operation in head injury. Med. Rec, Houston, 1937, 31: 243-7.—Butler, E. Wounds of the scalp and face. Am. J. Surg., 1930, n. ser., 8: 336.—Connell, J. E. A. The surgical management of severe head injuries. Colorado M., 1935, 32: 971-5.—Crosthwait, W. L. The surgical treatment of head injuries with special reference to remote sequelae. Texas J. M., 1937-38, 33: 610-13.—Delaney, W. E., jr. Man- agement of head injuries. Am. J. Surg., 1933, 21: 403-5. Also repr.—Edelstein, G. L. [Injuries of the skull and the brain] Ortop. travmat., 1938, 12: 18-27.—Finesilver, B., & Eiss, S. Head injuries. Am. J. Surg., 1934, 26: 535-42. Also repr.— Gosset, A. A propos de la chirurgie des plaies cranio-cerebrales. Mem. Acad, chir., Par., 1939, 65: 1079. —---- A propos des plaies cranio-cer<«brales. Ibid., 1940, 66: 219.—Greenleaf, P. E. Head injuries. Surg. J., 1926-27, 33: 37-40.—Gross, S. W. Emergency surgery of head injuries. Surg. Clin. N. America, 1935, 15: 301-10.—Hanke, H., & Grundies, H. J. Chirurgische Fruhindikationen bei Schadel-Hirnverletzungen. Deut. Zschr. Chir., 1939, 252: 381-95.—Johnson, L. W. Observations on head injuries. Am. J. Surg., 1935, 27: 518- 22 —Keegan, J. J. Surgical indications in head injuries. Colorado M., 1933, 30: 447-50.—Love, J. G. Management of head injuries. Surg. Clin. N. America, 1938, 18: 1005-20 — Marbury, W. B. Head injuries. Internat. J. Surg., 1928, 41: 525-9 —Martel.T.de. A propos des blessures craiiio-ce>eT>rales. Mem. Acad, chir., Par., 1939, 65: 1042-8.—Miller, I. D. Early indications for surgery in head injuries. Austral. N. Zealand J. Surg., 1938-39, 8: 176-81.—Munro, D. The emergency care of craniocerebral injuries. Am. J. Surg., 1937, 38: 739-44.— Nayak, K. M. Emergency surgery in head injuries. Ind. M. Gaz., 1928, 63: 439-44.—Ney, K. W. Craniocerebral trauma; practical considerations for the general surgeon. Am. J. Surg., 1J38, 42: 520-31.—Non-operable group of craniocerebral injuries. Ibid., 1940, 47: 1.—Rand, C. W. Treatment of aClit.e0nead ^juries; a few considerations. Ibid., 1930, n. ser., ?:JJ Reed- J- v- Treatment of acute head injuries. Ibid., 1936, 32: 79-83.—Ritter, A., & Lussi, U. Zur Bedeutung der chirurgisch-ophthalmologischen Zusammenarbeit bei Kopf- verletzungen. Schweiz. med. Wschr., 1939, 69: 1039-41.— Rodman, J. S. Head injuries. Surg. Clin. N. America, 1932, 12: 1505-15.—Ross, J. P. The surgical anatomy of head injuries. S. Barth. Hosp. J., Lond., 1925-26, 33: 67-70.— Rowlette, A. P., & Weiner, D. O. Craniocerebral injury. Surg. Gyn. Obst., 1941, 72: 551-6.—Sandler, S. A. Head injuries. Am. J. Surg., 1936, 34: 232-6.—Scott, M. Emer- gency treatment of head injuries in the accident dispensary. Ibid., 1940, 50: 678-83.—Swift, G. W. Head injuries. Ibid., 1934, n. ser., 26: 152-8. Also repr. ------& Flothow, P. G. Head injuries. Surg. Clin. N. America, 1931, 11: 1171-9.— Toussaint Martins, C. Tratamento dos traumatismos crdneo- encephalicos. Rev. brasil. cir., 1939, 8: 203-30.—Trotter, W. The evolution of the surgery of head injuries. Lancet, Lond., 1930,1: 169-71.—Verbrugghen, A. Treatment of head injuries. Surg. Clin. N. America, 1935, 15: 615-23.—Watt, J. H. Head injuries; a treatise from the viewpoint of diagnosis, prognosis and treatment. Am. J. Surg., 1938, 41: 272-4. ---- Treatment. German, W. J. Injuries to the head and neck. p.549-614. 8? N. Y., 1934. In Pract. Libr. M. & S. (Appleton) N. Y., 1934, 5: Hanson, A. M. Practical helps in the study and treatment of head injuries. 109p. 12? Bost. [1925] Abbott, W. D. The management of head injuries. Internat. J. M. & S., 1934, 47: 175-86.—Adson, A. W. The treatment of injuries to the head. Ibid., 1930, 43: 617-20.------ Injuries of the head. Proc. Mayo Clin., 1940, 15: 730-6.— Allen, S. S. Management of head injuries. Pennsylvania M. J., 1933, 36: 761-3.—Anderson, G. C. The management of head injuries. South. M. J., 1938, 31: 886-90.—Armour, D. J. The treatment of head injuiies. Practitioner, Lond., 1926, 97: 69-79.—Bamberger, A. Treatment of head injuries. Illinois M. J., 1940, 77: 159-62. — Basheehar Lai, K. Clinical report on head injuries from laboratory and therapeutic point of view. J. Ind. M. Ass., 1935-36, 5: 16-8.—Beatty, G. L. Head injuries. Tr. Hawaii M. Ass., 1938, No. 48, 121-6.— Boggon, R. H. Head injuiies. Nurs. Times, Lond., 1941, 37: 600; 622; 640.—Brody, B. S. The management of acute cranio- cerebral injuries. J. Am. M. Ass., 1940, 115: 977-83.— Coates, A. E. The treatment of head injuries. Med. J. Australia, 1934, 1: 312-5.—Coleman, C. C. The management of acute head injuries. South. M. J., 1937, 30: 196-201 — Crutchfield, W. G. The management of acute head injuries. South. M. & S., 1935, 97: 74-7. Dandy, W. E. Diagnosis and treatment of injuries of the head. J. Am. M. Ass., 1933, 101: 772-5. Also repr.------The treatment of injuries of the head. Pennsylvania M. J., 1935-36, 39: 755-9 — Dutta, P. C. Management of head injury cases in rural prac- tice. Ind. M. Gaz., 1938, 73: 26-30.—Earl, R. Treatment of head injuries. Minnesota M., 1935, 18: 521-5.—Fantus, B. El tratamiento de las lesiones de la cabeza [en el Cook County hospital] Rev. As. med. argent., 1940, 54: 407-10.------& Verbrugghen, A. The therapy of the Cook County hospital; head injuries. J. Am. M. Ass., 1940, 114: 243-6.—Fay, T. Head injuries; their management and treatment. J. S. Caro- lina M. Ass., 1935, 31: 233-43.—Fleming, H. Treatment of head injuries. Southwest M., 1935, 19: 261-4.—Flothow, P. G. Observations on treatment of head injuries. Northwest M., 1937, 36: 159-62.—Greenwood, J., jr. The treatment of craniocerebral injuries. Dis. Nerv. Syst., 1941, 2: 157-62.— Hatcher, A. R. Acute head injuries and their management. J. Kansas M. Soc, 1933, 34: 333-6.—Hepburn, H. H. The treatment of head injuries. Canad. M. Ass. J., 1929, 20: 20-3.—Love, J. G. The treatment of head injuries. Minne- sota M., 1934, 17: 644-8.—McCarthy, A. M. The treatment of head injuries. Mississippi Doctor, 1939-40, 17: 662-4 — McClure, R. D., & Crawford, A. S. The management of head injuries. J. Michigan M. Soc, 1927, 26: 549-55.—McGuire, L. D. Management of head injuries. Nebraska M. J., 1930, 15: 427-9.—McLeod, J. The management of head injuries. J. S. Carolina M. Ass.T 1938, 34: 303-7.—Meredith, J. M. The management of head injuries. Wrest Virginia M. J., 1940 36: 289-300.—Mixter, W. J. Treatment of head in- juries. J. Nat. M. Ass., 1926, 18: 119-23.—Money, R. A. The management of head injuries. Med. J. Australia, 1935, 2- 810-8.------The treatment of head injuries in general practice. Ibid., 1938, 1: 1084-9—MorriFsey, E. J. Head injuries; their treatment. California Wrest. M., 1931, 35: 198-201 —Prioleau, W. H. Diagnosis and treatment of injuries of the head. J. S. Carolina M. Ass., 1935, 31: 137.— Reed, J. V. The treatment of head injuries. J. Indiana M. Ass., 1928, 21: 321-7. ------ The treatment of injuries of the head and spine; head injuries. Med. Arts, 1933, 36: 123-35.— Reich, H. Treatment of head injuries. J. M. Soc. N. Jersey, lU'O 23: 497-502.—Rogers, L. The management of cases of head' injury. Clin. J., Lond., 1935, 64: 465-8.—Spessard, T. N. Prophylaxis in head injury. Virginia M. Month., HEAD INJURY 136 HEAD INJURY 1935 36, 62: 76-9.- Simonds, C. P.. & Jefferson, G. The treatment of head injuries. Brit. M. J., 1935, 2: 677-80. — Head injuries. In Treat. Cuu. Pract., 2. ed., Lond.. 1938. 2: 34-48.- Trotter. W. The management of hea.. injuries. Canada Lancet Pract., 1928. 71: 141-50.— Ver- brugghen, A. Treatment of head injuries. Illinois M. J., 1936, 69: 252 6.—Voris, H. C. The management of head injuries. Indust. M., 1941, 10: 60-4.—Weaver, J. C. Further observations on the management of head injuries. J. M. Ass. Georgia, 1926, 15: 43-8. Wortis, S. B. Head injuries, treatment and evaluation. J. M. Soc. N. Jersey. 1935, 32: 431. ---- Treatment: Methods. Borelli, J. F. *Thc conservative treatment of head trauma [Marquette Univ.] 2lip. 8? Hamilton, Ohio, 1932. Brewer, B. J. *Head injuries: treatment with hypertonic sucrose solution [Milwaukee Co. Gen. Hosp.] 12p. 28cm. [Wauwatosa] 1940. Bryant, G. E. *The use of dehydration therapy and lumbar punctures in the treatment of head trauma with cases. 20p. 4? Cleveland, Ohio, 1937. Cook, H. *Troatment of acute head injuries with summary of 25 cases [Milwaukee Co. Hosp.] 13p. 4? Wauwatosa, Wis., 1927-28. Houghton, J. H. *The modern management of head injuries [Marquette Univ.] 29p. 8? Wauwatosa, Wis., 1932. Wright, R. S. *Revie\v of recent literature of the management of head injuries [Milwaukee Gon. Hosp.] 1S|>. 4? Wauwatosa, 1938. Typewritten. Avendano, ('., & Horvitz, I. LI metodo deshidratante en la terapeutica de la hipertension intracraneana en algunas formas de traumatismos encfifalo-craneanos. Rev. med. aliment., Santiago, 1937-39, 3: 121-5.—Carroll, R. B. The diagnosis and treatment of acute traumatic head injuries. Med. Rec, Houston, 1933, 27: 342-5.—Carter, B. N. The management of acute head injuiies. Internat. Clin., 1933, 43. ser., 3: 223-9.—Coburn. I). F. The nonoperative treatment of head injuries. J. Missouri M . Ass., 1940, 37: 387-9. Dell, J. M., jr. The management of acute head injuries. J. Florida M. Ass., 1935-36, 22: 214.—Fay, T. Head injuries; the results ob- tained with dehydration in -18 consecutive cases. J. Iowa M. Soc, 1930, 20: 447-66- Freeman, W. The conservative treatment of head injuries. West Virginia M. J., 1932, 28: 348-51.- Furlow. L. T. Classification and treatment of acute head injuries. Week. Bull. S. Louis M. Soc, 1935,29:342-8.— Geib, F. W. Reduce- head injury mortality. N. York State J. M., 1939. 39: 1832-9.—Grav. F. D. Management of major injuiies. J. Florida M. Ass., 1940-41, 27: 346-9.—Hagan, H. H. The conservative treatment of head injuries. Ken- tucky M. J., 1926, 24: 94-7.—Jefferson, G. The treatment of acute head injuries. Brit. M. J., 1933, 1: 807-12.—Jianu, L, Popesco, V., & Slama, C. Contribution a 1'eLude et au traite- ment des traumatismes cranio-encephaliques. Rev. chir., Bucur., 1940, 43: 442-64.—Kennedy. F., & Wortis, S. B. How to treat head injuries and appraise them. J. Am. M Ass., 1932, 98: 1352. Also repr.—King, W. T. Head injuiies; conservative treatment with low mortality. Am. J. Surg 1936, 31 : 62; 91.—Knight, G. C. Modern "treatment of head injuries. Med. Press & Circ. Loud., 1938, 197: 398-404.— Leary. T. Morphine, head injuries and alcoholism. N. Kngland J. M.. 1935. 212: 216—Morphine, head injuries and alcoholism. Ibid., 207.—Munro, D. Convalescent care of patients with craniocerebral injuries. Ibid., 1.939, 220: 1023-6. ------ The immediate care of cranio-cerebral injuries. Proc. Interst. Postgrad. M. Ass. N. America (1940) 1941, 78-83.—Nash, C. C. The management of acute head injuries! Dallas M. J., 1936, 22: 58-61.—Palhasse. Sobre un afecto cerebral, i consecuencia cm. N. Y., 1940. Clendening, L. Health chats. 390p. 8? Phila. [1936] COCKEFAIR, E. A., & COCKEFAIR, A. M. Health and achievement; a textbook of health with a physiological background. 536p. 8? Bost. [1936] Cuzzort, B., & Trask, J. W. Health lessons. 37p.; 45p. 8? Bost., 1923. Davenport, C. B. How we came by our bodies. 401p. 8? N. Y. [1936] De Kruif, P. [H.] Health is wealth. 246p. 21cm. N. Y. [1940] Egbert, S. Personal hygiene for nurses. 347p. 8? Phila., 1930. Emerson, C, & Betts, G. H. Hygiene and health series. Book 1: Hygiene and health. 117p. 12? Indianap. [1930] Ferri, N. A. The behavior of health. 236p. 8? Bost., 1937. Germany. Kaiserliches Gesundheitsamt. Ge- sundheitsbuchlein. 9. Aufl. 255p. 12? Berl., 1904. Given, D. H. C. A new angle on health (Nature's provision for the health and happiness of mankind) 160p. 8? Lond., 1935. Greenwood, E. Who pays? 301p 8° Garden City, N. Y., 1934. Grotjahn, A, Die hygienische Forderung 183p. 8? Konigstein, 1921. Hall, C. Nature's pyramid to health. 159p 20cm. [Denver, 1938] Hay, W. H. Yours for good health (with answers to 128 questions) also containing extracts from the writings of the world's foremost health authorities. 133p. 8? Pittsb., 1932. ---- A new health era. 212p. 8? Mt Pocono, Pa. [1936] Hayhurst, E. R. Personal health. 279p. 8? N. Y., 1927. Heaps, W. J. The perfect man. 79p. 8? N. Y., 1918. Herdeg, H. B. Practical health talks. 28 1 4? Buffalo, N. Y., 1935. Hough, T., & Sedgwick, W. T. The human mechanism; its physiology and hygiene and the sanitation of its surroundings. 2. ed. 691p. 8° Bost. [1929] Hutchinson, W. The new handbook of health. 410p. 12? Bost. [1926] Igloe, M. C. Go down, death! 46 numb. 1. 28>km. Big Rapids, Mich., 1939. Jacob, A. G. Personal hygiene. 294p. 8? Bost., 1928. Jewett, F. G. Good health. Book 1. 172p. 12? Bost., 1906. Kirkpatrick, T. B., & Huettner, A. F. Fundamentals of health; the human organism, its development and conservation. 576p. 8? [Bost., 1931] Krueger, W. W. The fundamentals of per- sonal hygiene. 3. ed. 304p. 20}£cm. Phila., 1940. Le Bosquet, M. Personal hygiene. 220p. 12? Chic, 1926. Loughran, J. X. Your right to health. 150p. 181/2 cm. N. Y. [1936] Mallett, R. The book of health. 240p. 12? Lond. [1926] Meredith, F. L. Twelve hours of hygiene. 387p. 8? Phila. [1935] New York, N. Y. American Museum of Health. Man and his health. 96p. 25^cm. [N. Y.] 1939. Oberteuffer, D. *Personal hygiene for college students: a study of the curiosities, interests, and felt needs of college students in the subject matter of personal hygiene [Columbia Univ.] 121p. 8? N. Y., 1930. Oppenheim, S. Bau und Verrichtungen des menschlichen Korpers, mit besonderer Beriick- sichtigung der personlichen Hygiene. 239p. 8? Stuttg., 1930. Owen, M. E., ed. Health activities for all grades. 96p. 25cm. Dansville, N. Y., 1939. Rathbone, J. L., Bacon, F. L., & Keene, C. H. Foundations of health. 410p. 8? Bost [1936] Revell, D. G. Health. 2v. 668p.; 703p. 4? Chic, 1907. Rood, E., & Lingham, G. Taking care of the family's health. 2v. 598p. 25cm. Madison College, Tenn. [1938] Santori, S. L'igiene e la vita. 3. ed. 374p. 8? Roma, 1922. HEALTH 13S HEALTH Scholi., F. B. Library of health. 177Np. 4? Phila. [1927] Sharp, YV. B. The foundation of health. 2. ed. 2SSp. s: Phila., 1927. Also 3. ed. 30Sp. 1930. Small, E. Human body and health. 44Ip. S? Bost., 1S7S. Soi'Eif, H. W. Health essays. 41p. 8? Bost. [1930] Storey, T. A. General hygiene; constructive hygiene; the determining and contributory causes of health. Pt 1. 2. ed. 232p. 8? N. Y, 1926. Individual hygiene. 287p. 8? Stan- ford I'niv., 192S. Thackston, .1. A., & Thackston, J. F. Human health. 459p. 8? N. Y. [1931] Thomson, J. A. Towards health. 361p. 8? N. Y., 1927. Topham, T. W. Health of body and mind. 2.. 1936, 109: 71-;">.- Kyer.-on. E. S. Assessi- bility of health. Diplomato. 1910. 12: 21 I 8. Schilder, P. Health as a psychic experience. Arch. Neur. Psychiat., (.'hie, 1937, 37: 1322 37.—Short. J. J. Character and health. Proc. Life Ext. Exam., 1941, 3: 16 22. Sleeswijk, J. G. [What do we know about health?] Tschr. sociale hvg., 1917, 19: 69-73.—Spencer, R. R. Coimnonhealth (The) what is life? what is health? Health Off., Wash., 1937, 2: 345-9.- Sullivan, M. X. Good nature and good health. Clin. M. & S., 1927, 34: 422-4.—Techoueyres, E. Les ph6nomcnes fluxion- naires. Union mid. nordest, 1937, 60: 161 9.- Urhant- schitsch, R. Die wissenschalt liche Grundlage der Lcbens freude. Wien. med. Wschr., 1927, 77: 120-2. Van Gundy. M. D. Let's go out to eat. Health, Mount. Mew, .1911, 8: No. 7, 16.- Vos, A. The ideal bodv. Health Cult., N. Y., 1941, 47: No. 7, 7; 61—Warner. M. J. Vital health, your patriotic duty. Pins. Cult., N. Y., 1941, 85: No. 2, 6; 53 — Who has perfect health? J. Am. M. Ass., 1939, 113: 2334.— Williams, J. F. Physique and health. Am. J. Pub. Health, 1938, 28: 487-90—Win.-low, C. E. A. Health for better adventures. World's Health, Par., 1930, 11: 366-73 — Your (For) health's sake [radio script] Georgia Malaria Bull., 1940, 3: 28-8. ---- Care. See also in 3. ser. Hygiene, personal. [America] International Health Bureau of America. Feel young at 75; perfect health for 100 years. 152p. 8? Springf., Mo. [1926] American Social Hygiene Association. Health for girls. 12p. 12? N. Y., 1933. Ankenbrand, L. Gesund und schon ins Alter. 230p. 20>4cm. Stuttg. [1938] Arte di ringiovanire; come riguadagnarr dieci anni di vita in un solo mese di cura. 3. ed. 46p. 16? Milano [1935] Bacon, G. W. Practical guide to health and longevity. 136p. 12? Lond., 1881. Balasahib Pandita [Pant] Pratinidhi. The ten-point way to health. 112p. 19'^cin. N. V , 1939. Barker, J. E. Good health and happiness; a new science of health. 520p. 8? Lond. [1927] Barton, F. A. Good health; how to obtain and maintain it. 155p. 8? Lond. [1930] B.mer, W. W. Health questions answered. 368p. 8? N. Y. [1937] Bilik, S. E. Healthful living; the why and how. 261p. 8? N. Y., 1929. Black, J. R. Ten laws of health; or, How diseases are produced and prevented. 413n. 8? Bait., 1885. Blount, R. E. The science of everyday health. 415p. 8? N. Y. [1936] Brady, W. Personal health. 407p 8° Phila., 1916. Bragg, P. C. A system of health building. 8 1. 4? Burbank, Calif. [1936] Brainin [Road of life; popular hygiene] 267t>. 8? 3 pl. [Vilna] 1913. Text in Hebrew. Browning, E. Health in middle life. 249n. 18cm. Lond., 1938. Bryce, A. Ideal health and how to attain it. 102p. 12? Brisk, 1901. —— Ideal health; or, The laws of life and health. 340p. 8° Brisk, 1935. Bull, R. C. Freshman hygiene; personal and social problems of the college student. 288n. 8? Phila. [1926] Burkard, W. E., Chambers, R. L. [et al.] Health stories and practice. 256p. 8? Chic. Button, C. A. Mother and daughter; advice to the maiden, wife and mother. 153p 16° Holland, N. Y., 1903. Carton, P. The ten commandments of health and happiness. 95p. 12? N. Y., 1928 HEALTH 139 HEALTH Clegg, H. A. Brush up your health. 119p. 8? Lond., 1938. Clum, F. D. Health and how to keep it, 400p. 12? Bost., 1887. Cobb, W. F. Health for body and mind. 534p. 8? N. Y. [1936] Crampton, C. W. The boy's book of strength. 257p. 8? N. Y. [1936] De la Torre, T. The science of health, re- generation, rejuvenation, and longevity, or orthopathy. v. p. 4° S. Franc, 1934. De Renzi, E. L'arte di conservare la sanita; o. Trattato d'igiene popolare. 103p. 18}km. N. Y., 1939. Loomis, W. H. The health hunter. 348p. 8? Cleveland, 1931. McDonald, F. Sane living the master physician. 354p. 12? Phoenix [1926] McGovern, A. The. secret of keeping fit; an easy and sure way to better health. 247p. 8? Lond. [1937] Mackenzie, J. The history of health, and the art of preserving it: or, An account of all that has been recommended by physicians and philosophers towards the preservation of health, from the most remote antiquity to this time. 2. ed. To which is added a short and clear account of the com- mencement, progress, utility, and proper man- agement of inoculating the smallpox, etc. 2. ed. 436p. 8? Edinb., 1759. McKinnon, J. T. The road to health and happiness. 73p. 8? [Caddomills, Texas, 1933] Meignien. La renovation de l'hygiene. 2v. 464p.;528p. 12? [Par., 1921-22] Metropolitan Life Insurance Company. Lighting the way to health. 6 1. 22>^cm. N. Y. [1939] Mexico. Departamento de salubridad publica. Guia de salud. 183p. 8? Mexico, D. F., 1936. Mississippi, U. S. A. State Board of Health. Health syllabus. 80p. 8? Jackson [1936] Mueller, 0. C. Roads to health and happi- ness. 137p. 8? N. Y. [1936] New York, N. Y. Modern Living Health Institute. Case system science of health. In 12 sections, v. p., loose-leaf. 4? N. Y. [about 1935] Northfield, W. Highroads to health and happiness. 136p. 19cm. Lond. [1937] Olsson, N. W. Guarding our health. 155p. 8? N. Y. [1936] Palmer. O. A. Physical perfection. 212p. 18° Warren, O., 1897. Pursell, J. P. Stepping stones to health and happiness. 64p. 12? Phila. [1920] Ramus, C. Outwitting middle age. 269p. 12? N. Y., 1926. Reed, D. B. Keep fit and like it. 325p. 21cm N. Y. [1939] Reeder, D. H. Home health club; how to get well, how to keep young. lOlp. 8? La Porte, Ind., 1904. Roberts, H. Everyman in health and sick- ness. 739p. 8? Lond. [1935] HEALTH 140 HEALTH fit in war-time. 90p. lSkcm. 22'2cm. X. V SAFFORD, M. strength for girl Seymour, D. tion. 12p. 8? value of good It is your life. 450p. ---- Keep Lond. [1940] Robertson, G. The money health. 40p. V IVYash., 190S] Robey, W. H. Health at fifty. 299p. 21 Cambr., Mass., 1939. Rosenberg. M. M [1940] J & \llen, M. E. Health and 88p. 16° Host. [1884] C Perfect manhood: its rcstora- [X. Y., before 1900] Siuxks J. Your nose, throat, voice and hvgiene. 112p. s? Chic. [1936] Sherbon, F. B. The family in health and in illness. 516p. 8? X. Y., 1937. Sinclair, J. The code of health and longevity; or, A general view of the rules and principles calculated for the preservation of health, and the attainment of long life. 4. ed. 566p. 8? Lond., 1818. , , Steincrohn, P. J. More years for the asking. 218p. 19^cm. X. Y., 1940. Turner, C. E., & Collins, G. B. Cleanliness and health. 3. ed. 236p. 8? Bost. [1937] Tyrrell, C. A. The royal road to health; or, The secret of health without drugs. 375. ed. 237p. 12? X. Y., 1926. I'trecht, W. Be vour own doctor. 91p. 8? [X. Y., 1921] Y\n Bi skirk, E. F. Principles of healthful living. 386p. 8? X. Y. [1938] Yicentini, A. Xozioni generali d'igienc popolare. 42p. IS',em. Treviso, 1868. \Y vll F. P., & Zeidberg, L. D. Health guides and guards. 208|>. S? X. Y., 1936. Webster, W. VY. The family guide to health and happiness. 150p. 12? Dixon, 111., 1883. Whitmohe, E. R. Keeping young after forty. 207p. 12? X. Y., 192S. Williams, J. V. Healthful living, based on the essentials of physiology. Rev. ed. 596p. 8? X. Y., 1927. Also 2. ed. 605p. [1934] ---- Personal hygiene applied. 4. ed. 520p. 8? Phila., 1931. Also 5. ed. 529p. 1934. Williams, L. The science and art of living. 240p. S° Lond. [1924] Winslow, C. E. A. Healthy living. 2v. 216p. 35lp. 12? X. Y., 1927. ---- The road to health. 15lp. 8? X. Y., 1929. Wolfe AY. B. How to be happy though human. 391p. 224cm. X. Y. [1931] Woll, F. A. Constructive hygiene. 6p. 8? [Los Ang.. 1926] Woods, W. Y. Health; how to get and keep it. 196p. 18? Phila., 1905. Armstrong, D. B. Organized medicine and individual he?lth and medical guidance. J. Am. M. Ass., 1928, 91: 613-5.—B., A. L. Strong men who live biologically. Good Health, 1940, 75: 22.—Boulay, M. Hygiene de l'oreille, du nez, de la bouche et de la gorge. In Traite hvg. (Martin, L. & Bouardel, G.) Par., 1929. 3: 205-46.—Buzzard, E. F. Rest, work and play in health and disease. Brit. M. J., 1930, 2: S49--52.—Cathcart, E. P. The maintenance of health. Med. Off.. lond.. 1932. 48: 201-3.—Diehl, H. S. Stop killing yourself. H\ ir.-in. Ghic. 1941, 19: 168-70.—Dinwiddie, C. Promotion of health vs prevention of disease. Hosp. Social serv., 1929, 19: 565-73.—Gilcreest, E. L. The business of keeping well. Bull. Am. Coll. Surgeons, 1934, 18: 29.— Grant. L. Ten commandments of health. Caledon. M. J., I'.t3 I-35. 15: 389-92.—Haldane, J. B. S. Secrets of health. In his Adventures Biol., N. Y., HUM. 41-8.—Harris, S. The business of keeping well. Yiiirinia M. Month., 1928-29, 55: 675 -82.—Hart, P. Youth needs to conserve energy lor health's -ake Everybody's Health, 1934, 19: Xo. 9, 2.—Heiser, V. You're the doctor. Phys. Cult., N. Y., 1941, 86: No. 4, 11; 76.—Hutchison, R. The pursuit of health. Canad. M. Ass. J., 1931, 24: 16-21.—Kellogg, J. H. How to live as a health aristocrat. Good Health, 1938 73: 9; 38; 72.— Kummel. M. Walking for health. Health Shoe Digest, 19.it.. 1, 8: •>() 3. Lessons from the go. ilia. Good Health, 1941, "fi: 6.- Mountin, J. W., & O'Hani. H. Differences in opportunities f,.r health.. I*nl.. Health Hep.. 1938, 53: 485-96 — Moura Campos. F. A. de. A sebedona do corpo. Hospital, Bio, I'(39 15: 817-27.—Parran, T. Current opportunities for health conservation. Proc. Ass. Life Insur. Pres., 1937, 31: 51-9—Prentice, N. Get a kick out of life. Phys. Cult., N. Y., 1941, 85: No. 3, 20; 85. - Sen, H. C. How to avoid the influence of disease-germs. Ind. M. Rec, 1902, 22: 515. Sharpe, H. How famous people keep well. Phys. Cult., N Y 1941 86: No. 4, 30-2. Sherman, E. E. Conserving middle age. Med. Insur., 1925-26, 41: 011-6.- Simple ('I ho life in Tristan Da Cunha. Good Health, 1936, 71: 143; 155 - Swanholm, A. L. Lifted by biologic living from a total dis- ability pensioner to 100 percent health and a magna cum laude diplomatist. Ibid., 1941, 76: 54.—Take care of your safety margin Ibid., 51.—Telford, R. W. Hygienic clothing and hygiene house furnishing. Health Bull., Melb., 1925., No 3 67-9.—Value (The) of warnings; for your healths sake be sure and heed Nature's warnings. Ind. M. Rec, 1939, ">9- 4-1-6—Vaughan, W. T. Individual preventive medicine. Yindnia M Month., 1925-26, 52: 687-91.—Vos, A. How to keep well. Health Cult., N. Y., 1941, 47: No. 3, 7-9. ----- Lse will power for renewed health. Ibid., No. 5, 7-9.— Wooton, E. The conservation of youth. Dublin .1. M. Sc, 1917 164- 73-84.—Zwiilf Gesundheitsregeln fiir Jedermann. Reichsgesundhbl., 1936, 11: 197. ---- Habits. Almeida Junior, A. de. *Formacao de habitos sadios nas criancas. 16p. 8? S. Paulo, 1926. . , Geskll. A., & Abbot, J. W. The kinder- garten and health. 37p. 8? Wash., 1923. lNtat ions] Gig. .-an., .Moskva, 1939. 4: No. 5. 22-5.—Bowen, J. S. Why a department of health'.' Tr. Med. Chir. Fac. Maryland, 1925. 127: 102-15.—Hayhurst, E. R. A swan song in public health work. Am. J. Pub. Health, 1929, 19: 627-30.—Hertzog, L. S. The need for a depaitment of health. J. Am. Inst. Homeop., 1938, 31: 278.—Mountin. J. W. Variations in the form and services of public health organizations. Pub. Ilealth Hep.. Wash., 1938, 53: 523-37.—Norrie, G. [The health department and its predecessor] Lgcskr. laeger. 1939, 101: 651-5.- Palmer, G. T. Stronger public health departments. Minnesota M., 191S. 1: 129.— Sullivan, I). J. Recovery and the heabl. department. Health Hull., Newark. 1934, 17: 1.—Wilcox. R. W. The vagaries of boaids of health. Homeop. Rec, 1916. 31: 153-8. Also Med. Times. N. Y., 1916, 41: 273.—Winslow, F. S. Partners in public health. Canad. Nurse, 1937, 33: 72 -4. ---- Activities, and duties. See also under special names of activities as Child, Health service; Group medicine, Health promotion service; Quarantine; Sanitation; Ve- nereal disease, Prevention, &c. Herold, J. Latter day activities of the De- partment of health. 3p. 8? Phila., 1915. Walker, W. F., & Randolph, C. R. In- fluence of a public health program on a rural community. 106p. 19cm. N. Y., 1940. Baihary, F. L'inspection d^partementale d'hygiene, base de la protection de la sant6 publique; le quelle est; ce quelle devrait etre. Bull. Acad, med., Par., 1929, 3. ser., 102: 711-5.—Burkhalter. W. I). Relationship of public health activities to the real need. Am. J. Pub. Health., 1941, 31: 577-82.—Chapin, C. V. The relative values of public health procedures. J. Am. M. Ass., 1917, 69: 90-5. Also repr.— Coffee, J. H. Duties of a board of health. J. Florida M. Ass., 1918, 4: 226-8.—Copeland, R. S. How health officials guard the public against disease and death. Med. Bull. Univ. Cincinnati, 1920-22, 1: No. 3, 61.—Cumming, H. S. The evolution of the public health service. Mil, Surgeon, 1934 74: 169-76.— Dean, J. O., & Flook, E. How health depart- ments function with respect to specific problems. Pub. Health Rep., Wash., 1941. 56: 929-44.—Desirable minimum functions and organization principles for health activities. Am. J. Pub. Health', 1941, 31: No. 3. Suppl., 43-50.—Drinker, C. K. Problems and progress in public health. Pub. Health Nurs., 1936, 28: 10-4.—Field technical service added. Bull. Texas Dep. Health, 1939, n. ser., 1: No. 7, 6.—Fricks, L. D. A page from public health service history. Health Off., Wash., 1937, 2: 268.—Goodrich. C. H. The health department in the field of medicine, from the standpoint of a private practi- tioner. Am. J. Pub. Health, 1938, 28: 923-8.—Horton, T. The influence of engineering work of public health departments in the reduction of mortality. Pub. Health Bull., Wash., 1922, 120: 5-15.—Johjn, B. [The aims, instruments and results of the modern public health work] Orsz. Kozegeszs. Int. kozl., 1927-28, 1: No. 10, 1-14.—Jones, L. A. Essential activities of boards of health. Month. Bull. Massachusetts Dep. Health, 1918, 5: 366-71.—Leone, E. Pubblica igiene e polizia medica. Gior. farm, chim., Tor., 1866, 15: 378-80.—Lopez y Garcia. G. Delimitaci6n de funciones de las profe.siones sanitarias en la sanidad publica. Actas Congr. nac. san., Madr. M931) 1935. 1. Congr., 3: 459-64.—Mcintosh, W. A. Possibilities and limitations of full-time health services. Canad. Pub. Health J., 1939. 30: 219-25.—Miller, K. E. Public health at work. Trained Nurse. 1938, 100: 656-S.—Moine, M. Influence des travaux d'hygiene publique urbaine et rurale sur 1'eLat sani- taire des populations. Techn. san. mun., Par., 1940, 35: 2-9.- Mountin, J. W. A central information service on current practices of health depai tn ents. Am. J. Pub. Health, 1935 25: 247-53.—Nash. K. H. T. The public health service in the future. Pub. Health, bond.. 1934. 48: 8-15.—Nicoll. M.. jr. Houndaries of the public health field. J. Am. M. Ass I <\-><\ 87: 213-5. Also repr.- Pennell. E. H. The validity of health service data gathered bv the family survev method Pub Health Rep., Wash., 1938. 53: 439-46.—Ripgin, I. C. Ex- pansion of functions and responsibilities of health depart- ments; chairman's address. J. Am. M. Ass., 1939, 113: 275. ------Communications from the State health.department are valuable. Virginia M Month. 19 0, 6?: 563.- RoaUa. G. B. Developments in the public health field. Cam. M. \ss J 1929,21:645 50. Also Hosp. Social N-rv. 19-9, 20: 437-16.- Saltcrfield. I.. Planning and conduct of he held program. Papers Health Work. Conf. Tennessee. 9.18, 10: S> 7 —Swords, M. W. The duties of officials relative to Public health. N. Orleans M. & S. .1.. 1922 23 75: 121,- Tabulation of health department -ivm s. Pub. Health Rep., Wash 1936, 51: 1236-51—Tracy. M. Safeguarding tin public health. Pennsylvania M. .1., 1939 40, 43: 9..9 61. Vnrck B. [Economic and social aims in public healt li| Vest. .e-k lek., 1936, 48: 1; 37; 68.- Wilinsky, ('. F. Changes m public-health practice. N. England .1. M., 1940, 222: 831-6. ---- Administrative function. Kramer, V. H. A study in public administra- tion. S7p. 22>;jcm. New Haven, Conn., 1937. Batkis, G. A. | Kcsults and future problems in sanitary service statistics] Gig. san., Moskva, 1939, 4: No. 11, 21-7.— Bellows, M. T., & Ramsey, G. H. Integration of health de- partment records. Am. .1. Pub. Health, 1939, 29: 636 40 — Besichtigung der (iesundheitsamter. Reichsgesundhbl.. 1938, 13- 161—Bishop, E. L. Modern trends in public health administration. Am. J. Pub. Health, 1934, 24: No. 6, 591-3. Administrative practice. Ibid., 1941, 31: No. 3, Suppl., 52-5. Brown, A. M. Changing values in public health administration. J.R.San. Inst., 1937-38, 58: 722 33. Burton, J. H. Mechanical devices for the public health de- partment. Med. Off.. Lond., 191(1, 64: 93-5.—Butler. A. J. Current analysis as a guide for administration. Rep. Conf. Tennessee Health Work., 1932, 5: [Discussion] 153-60 — Coffey, E. R. Practical administrative problems in public health. Bull. Texas Dep. Health, 1939 [n. ser.] 1: No. 7, 1-3.—Crumbine, S. J. Insecurity of tenure as obstacle to public health administration. Am. J. Pub. Health, 1926, 16: 557-64. — Definiciones e instrucciones para la tabulaci6n de los servicios prestados por los departarrentos de sanidad. Hoi. Of. san. panamer., 1937, 16: 523-37.—Derryberry, M., & Dean, J. O. A procedure for putting health department reports to work. Pub. Health Rep., Wash., 1939, 54: 1709- 18.—Draper, W. F. Administrative practice in public health. Illinois Health Mess., 1935, 7: 55.—Dublin, L. I. Fifteen vears of the Committee on Administrative Practice; the initial steps. Am. J. Pub. Health, 1935, 25: 1290-302 — Earp, J. R. Administrative practice in the West. Ibid., 1936, 26: 761-3.—Efimov. A. [Health departments of city councils as organs of municipal activity] Profil. med., Kharkov, 1928, 7: No. 4, 134-8.—Enneis, W. H. Importance of record- ing, tabulating, analyzing and reporting the work of a health depaitment. Papers Health Work. Conf. Tennessee, 1937, 9: 81-3.—Ferguson, W. J. Removing health departments from, politics. J. Missouri M. Ass., 1921, 18: 185-7.—Freeman, A. W. The modern phase1 of health administration. Ohio M. J., 1926, 22: 41-5.—Fyfe, G. M. A new era in public health administration. Papers James Mackenzie Inst., S. Andrews, 1933, No. 1, 5-9.—Grayson, W. B. Some current problems in public health administration. Proc. Conf. Health Author. N. America, 1940, 55. Meet., 33-0.—Hutcheson, R. H. The part the clerk plays in the successful maintenance of the local health department. Papers Health Work. Conf. Tennessee, 1938, 10: 139-41.------Sanford, W. V. [et al.] [Round-table discussion of technical problems and administra- tive problems] Ibid., 40—(il.—Johan, B. [Requirements ol health administration] Nepeg's/segiigy, 1937, 18: 1-8. AlsoOiYoskepzes, 1937, 27: 10 5—Kelley, E. R. The develop- ment of public health administration. Proc. Nat. Conf. Social Work, 1923, 50: 166-70.- Krug, J. Die Statistik in der staatlichen Gesunoneiisfiihiung und Verwaltung. Munch. med. Wschr., 1939, 86: 1 164-7.—Loir, A. Luniformisation des comptes rendus des bureaux d'hvgiene. Rev. prat. hyg. mun., Par., 1916, 11: 57-66.—Macgregor, A. S. M. The scientific basis of public health administration. Glasgow M J 1926, 105: 351-9.—Mclver, P. Brunswick-Greensville health administration studies No. 4. Pub. Health Rep Wash., 1935, 50: 469-80.—McLaughlin, A. J. Public health administration. Ibid., 1930, 45: 1191-200.—Mountin. J. W. The place of an index in health department record keeping. Ibid., 1940, 55: 387-93.—Mustard, H. S. Administrative practice in the district plan. Illinois Health Mess., 1941, 13: Lj ''■ . °r,lz- p- N- Underlying principles of public health administration. Porto Rico J. Pub. Health, 1929-30, 5: 433 7 Patterson, M. Some suggestions on graphic presenta- tion of information in county health departments. Papers Health Work. Conf. Tennessee, 1938, 10: 141-6.—Peterson, U. C. Importance of reporting, recording, tabulating, and analyzing the work of a health department. Ibid., 1937, 9: [Discussion] 83790--Rice, J. L. Fifteen years of the Com- mittee on Administrative practice; the viewpoint of a health officer. Am. J. Pub. Health, 1935, 25: 1317-20.- Smith, H. A. Common sense in public health administration West Vir- ginia M. J., 1940, 36: 406-8.—Sosnovy, T. N. IMethods of investigation of health service in district cente.s| Gig. san., Moskva, 1940 5: No. 11, 45.—Thomas. E. W. l)e,-entralisa- tion as an aid to economy in public health administration. J. R. San. Inst., 1933. 54: 287-91.- Upson, L. I). Principles of administration applicable to health department*. Am J. HEALTH BOARD 143 HEALTH BOARD Pub. Health, 1941, 31: 39-44.—Vaughan, H. F. Keeping the health department out of politics. Trained Nurse, 1940, 104: 38-41.—Williams, W. C. Report of the Committees on Records and Reports. Proc. Conf. Health Author. N. America, 1940, 55. Meet., 130-3— Winslow, C. E. A. The appraisal of administrative health practice. J. R. San. Inst., 1926-27, 47: 133-51. ------ Fifteen years of the Committee on Administrative Practice; the evolution of the program. Am. J. Pub. Health, 1935, 25: 1303-16. ---- Cost and budgeting. See also Group medicine, Health promotion service: Cost and budgeting. Ripley, E. M. An address delivered before the Eclectic Medical Association of Connecticut, in which questions of interest to every tax- payer and health-lover are discussed. 8p. 8°. Hartford, 1894. Adams, F. The preparation of a budget and its satisfactory apportionment for a citv with a full-time health department. Canad. Pub. Health J., 1930, 21: 157--61.—Capes, W. P. Health budgets. Month. Bull. N. York State Dep. Health, 1919, n. ser., 14: 172-4.—Daley, W. A. The costs and results of various public health activities. Med. Off., Lond., 1921, 26: 39.—Dangers of too much economy in public health work. Med. J. & Rec, 1933, 138: 11.—Dickie, W. M. Economics of a full time health program. Nation's Health, Chic, 1923, 5: 150-2.—Fales, W. T. Expenditures of health departments. Pub. Health Bull., Wash., 1923, 136: 32-51. ch.—Ferrell, J. A. Economics of public health. J. Am. M. Ass., 1927, 89: 77-82.—Fiemartle, F. E. The economics of public health. Brit. M. J., 1922, 2: 338-41. Also Postgrad. M. J., Lond., 1925-26, 1: 121-5.—Heiser, G. Economic aspects of public health. Nat. M. J. China, 1919, 5: 199-210.—Hemenway, H. B. Economics of health administration Am. J. Pub. Health, 1920, 10: 105-12.— Jenkins*. R. B. Municipal health, expenditures in Canada. Canad. Pub. Health J., 1934, 25: 120-3.—Kane, C. A. Financing full-time health departments. South. M. J., 1926, 19: 739-42.—Martin. A. J. Economy and public health. J. R. San. Inst., 1924-25, 45: 146-51.— Messier, A. J. Cost accounting. Am. J. Pub. Health, 1939, 29: 515-20.—Meyer, E. C. Methods for the defence of public health appropriations. Ibid., 1920, 10: 201-9.—Mountin, J. W. Specific expenditures and personnel of official health agencies in certain cities. Ibid., 1935, 25: 545-50.—Mu- khamediarov, F. G. [On an operative-finance plan of medical sanitary departments] Kazan, med. J., 1941, 37: 64-9.— Southard, H. G. The economic status of public health ad- ministration. Ohio M. J., 1933, 29: 695-8— Sydenetricker, E. Economy in public health. Q. Bull. Milbank Mem. Fund, 1936, 14: 3-12.—Violette & Even. La protection de la sant£ publique et la politique des Economies. Rev. hvg., Par., 1924, 46: 475-88.—Walker, W. F. Analysis of public health ex- penditures by geographic subdivisions. Am. J. Pub. Health, 1935, 25: 851-6. ---- federal, or national. Felix, J. Un ministere du travail de l'hygiene et de l'assistance publique. 6p. 8? Brux., 1902. A16pee, P. Vers un ministere de l'hvgiene. Rev. philan- throp., Par., 1918, 39: 412-5.—Astor, W. Health problems and a State ministry of health. Med. Press & Circ, Lond., 1917, 104: 372-4. Also J. State M.. Lond., 1918, 26: 170-7.— Bayliss, W. M. A ministrv of health. Nature, Lond., 1918. 101: 121-3.—Black. J. B. The establishment of a federal bureau of health. Canad. M. Ass. J., 1918, 8: 333-5.—Bryce, P. H. The scope of a federal department of health. Am. J. Pub. Health, 1919, 9: 650-3. Also Canad. M. Ass. J., 1920, 10: 1-10. Also Canad. Pract. & Rev., 1919, 44: 326-31 — Calver, H. N., & Tobey, J. A. National health departments in review. Nation's Health, Chic, 1921, 3: 391-4.—Cox, R. L. A clearing house for health departments. Proc Conf. San. Off. N. York, 1911, 11: 76-84.—Doctor (A) needed in the Cabinet. N. York M. J., 1917, 106: 32. Doizy. Sur la creation d'un ministere de la sante publique est-il El d6sirer qu'on rende plus homogSnes entre eux les divers organismes d'hygiene gouvernementaux, dlpartementaux et municipaux? Rev. hyg., Par., 1916, 38: 865-77.—Doyle, A. Development of federal public health functions ir. the LTnited States. Pub. Health Nurse, 1920, 12: 723; 876.—Even. Comment concevoir un ministere de la sante publique? Rev. hyg.. Par., 1921, 43: 355-63 (Discussion] 519-31.—Faivre. P. Faut-il faire un ministere de la sante publique? Ibid., 1919, 41: 163; 268. Ferrari. La vigilanza igienica alia Camera; il discorso di Celli. Italia san., 1909, 5: 134-7.—Grant, J. B. Appraisal of national health administration. Am. J. Hyg., 1926, 6: 450-62.—Gulick, L. The status of health departments in the cabinet form of State government. Proc. Conf. Health Author. N. America, 1931, 46: 68- 92.—Hope, E. W. The influence of a ministrv of health on local organization and administration. J. State M., Lond., 1918, 26: 338-44 — Interstate sanitary districts. Pub. Health Rep., Wash., 1915, 30: 1601.—Le Fur, R. A propos d'un Ministere de la Sante publique. BuU. med., Par., 1919, 33: 8; 39.—Mayo, C. H. A cabinet officer for supervision of national health and educa- tional problems. J. Am. M. Ass., 1920, 74: 691.—Movement (The) for a National Department of Health. Ibid., 1913, 60: 1382-5.—Navrrre. Creation d'un ministere de la sante publique. Rev. hyg., Par., 1918, 40: 628-44.—Parker, C. A. The medical services under a Ministry of Health Pub Health, Lond., 1919, 32: 87-92.—Pietravalle, M. Per un Mimstero della saniU ed assistenza pubblica in Italia. Mondo med., Roma, 1920, 2: 118-36.—Posn.er, C. Medizinalminis- tenen. Berl. klin. Wschr., 1919, 56: 93.—Proposed (The) ministry of health. Lancet, Lond., 1918, 1: 575; 746.— Rankin, W. S. A supreme national need: coordination and enlargement of federal health activities. Am. J. Pub Health 1919, 9: 819-22.—Roesde, E. Die Organisation der Gesund- heitsmimsterien in verschiedenen Landern. Arch, sozial Hve 1922-23, 15: 121-47.—Rojas, N. Federalism^ a- sanidad" Sem. med., B. Air., 1937, 44: 1427-9.—Russell, A. W. A ministry of health. Practitioner, Lond., 1918, 100: 70-80__ Sheard, C. A Federal Health Department. Canad Pract 1919, 44: 89-92.—Steel, M. A Federal Department of Health! Ibid., 92-7.—Teleky, L. Em Ministerium fur Volksgesundheit und soziale Filisorge. Wien. klin. Wschr., 1917, 30: 759. ---- Legal activities. See also Health law. Baker. J. N. The health department as policeman. J M Ass. Alabama, 1933, 2: 473-5.—Jenkins, L. V. Police co- operation with public health and sanitation officials. Health Off., Wash., 1936-37, 1: 341-7.—Todd, W. J. The rules and regulations of our health boards from a general physician's point of view. Bull. Univ. Maryland School M., i919-20, 4: 6-14.—Welch, S. W. The executive authorities of the state board of health. Tr. M. Ass. Alabama, 1915, 356-60. ---- Organization. For organization in various countries and cities see Health organization; also Group medicine, Health promotion service: Organiza- tion. Handley, H. E. The field unit in local public health service, Tennessee and Mississippi, 1930- 1937. 50p. 20}£cm. N. Y., 1938. Hiscock, I. V., ed. Community health or- ganization. 3. ed. 318p. 23V;cm. N Y 1939. Araoz Alfaro, G. Administraci6n sanitaria, organizaci6n autonomica y tecnica. Rev. As. mid. argent., 1938, 52: 1141-7.—Brown, H. D. Health departments in smaller industries. Proc Nat. Conf. Social Work, 1932, 59: 145-55.— Chandler, W. W. Formation of sanitary districts in recreation areas. Am. J. Pub. Health, 1935, 25: 479.—Chueca, M. E. Organizacion y funcionamiento del grupo de higiene y pro- filaxia. Rev. san. mil., Lima, 1936, 9: 115-36.—Crichton, W. H. Lecture on co-ordinated effort in hvgiene. Ind. Mi Gaz., 1941, 76: 240-2.—Dichtiar, S. [Present day problems of sanitary organization] Profil. med., Kharkov, 1927, 6: No. 8-9, 122-9.—Drake, C. St. C. District health organization, j] Am. M. Ass., 1916, 67: 1723-5.—Efimov, A. [Pen or test- tube?] rcle of sanitary organization. Profil. med., Kharkov 1927, 6: No. 5, 146-53.—Efimov, D. [New ideas and new currents in health organization] Ibid., No. 8-9, 142-61.— Elliot, E. G. S. Public health aspects of planning. J. State M., Lond., 1935, 43: 282-91.—Fosduck, S. J. What industry has learned about leadership; its application to public health. Pub. Health Rep., Wash., 1941, 56: 110-6.—Habernoll. Die Zusammenarbeit der Gesundheitsamter mit amtlichen Dienststellen (auf Grund der Verordnungen und Erlasse seit 1933) Oeff. Gesundhdienst, 1937-38, 3: A, 509-21.—Handley, H. E. The field unit, a new approach to the coordination of State and local health service. Proc. Conf. Health Author. N. America, 1935, 50: 64-77.—Hopkins, E. D. Plan de organizacion de un departamento de ingenierfa sanitaria. Bol. Of. san. panamer., 1940, 19: 682-4.—Jones, L. A. The relationship between the state and local boards of health. Am. J. Pub. Health, 1915, 5: 648-50—Lipschiitz, J. T. [San- itary organization fetishism] Profil. med., Kharkov, 1927, 6: No. 2, 124-7.—McCreary, A. B. Medicine, public health and local government. J. Florida M. Ass., 1940-41, 27: 279-82.—McPhaul, W. A. The State Board of Health and county health units. Health Notes, Jacksonville, 1938, 30: 99.—Mead, K. C. Some problems of state health organization. Proc. Connecticut M. Soc, 1917, 135: 95-101.—Mostyn, S. G. Collaboration between the military and sanitarv authorities. Pub. Health, Lond., 1915, 28: 159-63—Mustard, H. S. Integration of health department activities. Papers Health Work. Conf. Tennessee, 1937, 9: [Discussion] 11-6.—Pierce, C. C. Unity of organization for public health activities. Texas J. M., 1920-21, 16: 377-80— Quadflieg. Ueber Er- fahrungen und Schwierigkeiten bei der Errichtung der Ge- sundheitsamter. Oeff. Gesundhdienst. 1936-37, 2: A, 91-6.— Rankin, W. S. The standardization of public health work. Am. J. Pub. Health, 1915, 5: 1024-30.—Ratzefeld, F. [With pen and test-tube; concerning further development of sanitary HEALTH BOARD 144 HEALTH BOARD organization] Profil. med., Kharkov, 1927. 6: Xo. 8-9, 117- 21.- Spears. H. H. Administrative units of Incal eovernrrent. J. R >an. Inst., 1936-37, 57: 687-701 — I'aOda. V. de. Difi- i-uldades na organizacao edirccao dos scrvivoi- de saude publica. Arch. hyg.. Rio. 1937, 7: S3-9L- Vcrgi ra. J.J. Com n unity health-social cenWrs. Month. Bull. Bui, Health, Manila, 1937, 1'. : 337 10- Wabh. J. J. Hoards of health for the mind. Med limes, N. V.. 1923, 51: 121; 144; 155 —Warren, B. S. A unified health service. Pub. Health Rep., Wash., 1919, 377- 85. ---- Personnel. See also Health inspector; Health nurse; Health officer; Sanitary engineer, HEALTH EXAMINATION M. Soc, 1935, 34: 145.—Congres international de propagande d'hygiene sociale et d'education prophylactique sanitaire et morale. Bull. Soc. fr. prophyl. san., 1923,23: 83-94.—Connolly, M. P. Interpreting the physician and making him a part of the health education piocram. Am. J. Pub. Health, 1939, 29: 473-6. Cooporacion n,u lasecretarla de sanidad y beneficencia en trabajos educacionales. San. & benef., Habana, 1940, 43: 55-67. -Gumming, H. S. Dfa panamericano de la salud. Rev. hig., Bogota, 1941, 22: 5.—Delater, G. Les journees du Service de sante national. Presse mid., 1938, 46: 981-3.— Kl club Obras Sanitarias; claro exponente de la capacidad de asociaci6n del personal. Bol. obras san. nac, B. Air., 1937, 1: 648-52.—Emerson, H. The influence of the practitioner of medicine in guiding the public towards health. Ann. Int. M., 1931, 5: 57-61.—En la Asociaci6n medica peruana Daniel A. Carri6n; actuaci6n en homenaje al Dia panamericano de la salud. Rev. mid. peru., 1940, 12: 452-5.—Gomensoro, J. Propaganda y educaci6n higi^nicas. Bol. sal. pub., Montev., 1941, 2. epoca, 1: 80-96.—Grashchenkov, N. I. [Aims of public health a nd the importance of the medical press] Vrach. delo, 1938, 20: 801-4.—Health education in Cincinnati. J. Am. M. Ass., 1941. 117: 865.—Herman, G. J. The physician as an educator and as a sanitarian. Kentucky M. J., 1911, 9: 241- I. Hiscock, 1. V. Clinical case studies as instruments in the teaching of public health. J. Am. M. Ass., 1931, 96: 970-2 — Holmes, M. E. Why not mobilize the health of the nation. Health Cult., N. Y., 1941, 47: No. 9, 20.—Horning, B. G., Morgan, L. S. [et al.] The community health education pro- gram, the Hartford plan; audio-visual unit. Am. J. Pub. Health, 1941, 31: 310-8.—Hoskins, J. D. The state university's place in a public health program. Papers Health Work. Conf. Tennessee, 1938, 10: 21-7.—Jean, S. L. Health publicity in New Mexico health district. Southwest M., 1935, 19: 285-8.— Kiss, M. [Cleaning-up campaign in an agricultural town] Nepegeszsegugy, 1937, 18: 222.—Kohl, ('. C. Health education and the physician. Ohio M. ,L, 1930, 26: 680-5- Linthicum, G. M. How the public can help the medical profession to fight disease. Maryland M. J., 1909, 52: 191; 160.—McKay, F. L. Health education in maternity and infancy. Commonhealth, Bost., 1937, 24: 172-5—Martinez Baez, M. El Dia pan- americano de la salud. Gac. mud. .Mexico, 1940, 70: 642-7.— Marzeev, A. N. [Instillation of simple sanitary and hygienic rules into the communal service of institutions of densely populated villages] Gig. san., Moskva, 19 10, 5: No. 11, 1-4.— Mayer, C. F. [Fables of hygienic educative character in the middle ages] Orv. hetil., 1928, 72: 272.—Merlot, J. Croisade de la Sant6; province d'Anvers. Bull. Min. san. pub., Brux., 1938, 3: 273-5.—Nicoll, M. Public health education, with especial reference to the use of the printed page. J. Am. M. Ass., 1927, 89: 118-23.—Pavolotsky. K. A. [Future hygienic education in the Ukraine] Vrach. delo, 1941, 23: 221-6.— Pe>ez Sotomayor, G. Para educar al publico. Salud & san., Bogota, 1937, 6: No. 53, 2-5.— l'runeda, A. La secretaria de instrucci6n publica de Mexico y su actuaci6n sanitaria. Actas Congr. As. in6d. panamer. (1928-29) 1930, 1. Congr., 289-95 — Public health education in Jamaica. Jamaica Pub. Health, 1934, 9:59-63.—Putto, J. A. [Public health and the press] Geneesk. gids, 1941, 19: 182-90.—Report of the Council on Health and Public Instruction. J. Am. M. Ass., 1919, 72: 1745-51.— Rios Castro, R. La educaci6n sanitaria'en el Distrito de Colum- bia. Bol. Of. san. panamer., 1940, 19: 667-74.—Rochlin, S. [Methodology of educational sanitary work in the village] Belaruss. med. dumka, 1927, 3: 26-30.—Sequeira, J. H. The educational aspect of public health work in the tropics (with special reference Ki Kenya) East Afr. M. J., 1932, 9: 59-78.— Shearer, O. I.. A national physical and health education scheme. J. R. San. Inst., 1938-39, 59: 91-8.—Shultz, H. E. [Methods in organization of sanitary and cultural campaigns in populated areas] Gig. san., Moskva, 1939, 4: No. 6, 54-6.— Spencer, R. R. What's wrong with health education? Health Officer, Wash., 1936-37, 1: 389-93— Sleichen, M. A plan for community organization in health education. Med. Woman J., 1941, 48: 279-82.—Steinhardt. Dei Arzt als Lehrer. Zschr. Schulgesundh., 1927, 40: 353-8.—Temkin, O. Health education through the ages. Am. J. Pub. Health, 1940, 30: 1091-5. Also Med. Off., Lond., 1940, 64: 175—L'rihe Lince, A. Memorandum de las eampafias sanitarias del Cliaco, 1931-36 Rev. hig., Bogotfi, 1936, 17: 69-104.—Varadi, S. [Need for an Hungarian popular public health periodical] Nepegeszsegugy, 1940, 21: 1184-7.—Vaughan, V. C. Report on the Council on Health and PubUc Instruction. J. Am. M. Ass., 1920 74- 1239; 1921, 76: 1671.—Wilbur, R. L. The health officer as an educator. Proc. Conf. Health Author. N. America, 1931, 46: 15-9.—Williams, W. C. Coordination of health education between State departments of public health and public instruc- tion. Ibid. (1939) 1940, 54. Meet., 43-9. HEALTH examination. See also Diagnosis; Employee, Medical exam- ination; Fitness; Industrial worker; Life ex- tension, &c; also Preventive medicine; also names of various occupations. For • health examination of the population of cities and countries see Health survey; also names of cities and countries. Emeuson, W. R. P. The diagnosis of health. 272p. 8° N. V., 1930. Bass. C. C. Health examinations. Med. Clin. N. America, I927-2S 11 : 1117-22.— Bcggs, S. T. The diagnosis of health. Pub. Health, Lond., 1936-37, 50: 73 6 — Bird, B. C. The routine physical examination; its value to the patient and to the physician. Tr. M. Ass. Alabama, 19.1(1, 63: 191-200 — Boyd, J. I). The physician's view of health examination. J. Pediat., S. Louis, 1935, 7: 735-40.- Britten. It. II. The physical examination as an instrument of research. Med. OIL, Lond., 1931, 46: 189-90. Also Tub. Health Rep., Wash., 1931, 46: 1671-6.—Brooks, H. II. The routine health examina- tion. Proc. Interst. Postgrad. M. Ass. N. America (1930) 1931, 6: 202-8.—Bryant, B. L. Health examinations. J. M. Soc. N. Jersey, 1925, 22: 33 40.—Burns, I). The assessment of phvsical fitness. Nature, Lond., 1939, 111: -466-70.—Dodson, J. M. Physical examinations. J. Lancet, 1927, 47: 396-400 — Droogleever Fortuyn, A. B. [Analysis ol the human being] Ned. tschr. geneesk., 1925, 69: 1902-12.- Harp, J. R. Health examinations and the physician. .1. Am. M. Ass., 1928, 90: 383.—Emerson, W. R. P., A Cragin. I). B. Health diagnosis in adults; a study and a demonstration. Indust. M., 1935, 4: 1-4. ------ Health diagnosis in adults; a demonstration in life insurance practice. Ibid., 573-5.— I'lcniming-Mtfller. P. [On the <|iiestion of health] Nord. med., 1939, 1: 253.— Freund, II. A. The routine physical examination. J. Michigan M. Soc, 1933, 32: 90-2.—Goodwin, T. M. Ophthalmic pointers in general physical examination. West, Virginia M. J., 1938, 34: 299-301.—'Kessler, H. H. The determination of phvsical fitness. J. Am. M. Ass., 1940, 115: 1591-5. La Malle. H. C. Physical examination as health insurance. Pacific (oast, J. Nurs., 19-10, 36: 594.—Lee, L. II. A study relating to health examinations. Abstr. Proc. Ass. Life Insur. M. Dir. America, 1935, 21 : 29-33.—Lee. R. I. • Health examinations. Boston M. & S. J., 1927, 196: 559-81.—Levine. M. The diagnosis of normality. J. Med., Cincin., 1939-40, 20: 244-51.—Levy, D. M. A method of integrating physical and psychiatric examination; with special studies of body interest over-protec- tion, response to growth and sex difference. Am. J. Psychiat., 1929, 9: 121-91.—McSwiney, B. A.. Kiclianlson. I). T. [el al.] Discussion on the assessment of physical fitness. Proc. It. See. M., Lond., 1938-39, 32: Med. & Lnil,. Serv. Sect., 1539-5(1.- Muhlberg, W. Conservation of health examinations. J. Med., Cincin., 1930-31, 11: 70-8.—Nelson, C. F. An evaluation of the normal. J. Kansas M. Soc, 1933, 34: 379-84.—Pepper, O. H. P. The routine thorough medical examination; its importance as illustrated by a series of cases of obscure eye disease. Long Island M. J., 1927, 21: 11-20.—Perrusi, L. C, & De Lio, J. C. El examen morfol6gico individual segun la escuela italiana. Dfa med., B. Air., 1930 31, 3: 684.—Potter, M. C. A quarter century of health examinations. Med. Woman J., 1913, 38: 120-3.—Russell, P. F.. & Holl, R. L. Physical examination of the employees of a. government bureau in Manila, Philippine Islands. Mil. Surgeon, 1932, 71: 322. Also repr.—Ryerson, E. S. Asscssibility of health. Canad. Nurse, 1940, 36: 271-6—Sa, C. O diagnoslico da saude. Fol. med., Rio, 1930, 11: 280-3.—Simon, T., & Rougean, M. Feuille d'examen physique. Ann. med. psychol., Par., 1937, 95: 289-95.—Sison. A. B. M. Notes on physical examination. J. Philippine Islands M. Ass., 1937, 17: 757-70.—Taylor, E. A. Health examinations and vacations. Am. J. Nurs., 1935, 35: 1173-6.—Thayer, W. S. The diagnostic importance of physical examination. Mil. Surgeon, 1929, 65: 497-514. Also repr.— Tuohy, E. L. General physical examination. Minnesota M., 1931, 14: 974-7.—Weiscnburg, T. TI. The slu.lv of normals. J. Am. M. Ass., 1929, 93: 377-80.- Weinberg. V.'V. [Relative importance of various factors in valuation of general health] Voen. med. J., 1930, 1: 3-15.—Zneper, G. Uebei Praxis und Wert von Prufungen der korperlichen Leistungsfiihigkeit, bei Gesunden und Kranken, mit praktischen Reispielen. Luft- fahrtmedizin, 1937-38, 2:340-53. ---- Methods, and technique. American Medical Association. A manual of suggestions for the conduct of periodic examina- tions of apparently healthy persons. 55p. 8? Chic, 1925. Fisk, E. L. Manual of procedure in periodic physical examinations. 121 p. 16? [N. Y.] 1925. ——- & Crawford, J. R. How to make the periodic health examination; a manual of pro- cedure. 393p. 8? N. Y., 1927. Beardsley, E. J. G. The periodic health examination; the correlation of the findings and formulation of advice. Week. Roster, Phila., 1936, 32: 11-6.—Bliss, J. G. The validity of the medical examiner's rating. Am. J. Pub. Health, 1926, 16: 980-7.—Buck, R. W. Some important details in the technique of the health examination. Proc. Life Ext. Exam., 1939, 1: 51-4.—Cary, E. H. The ophthalmologist and otolaryngologist in periodic health examinations. Tr. Am. Acad. Ophth. Otolar., 1926, 31: 120-34.—Causey, Z. Periodic physical examinations by the family physician. Southwest. M., 1925, 9: 178-80.— Champion, M. E. Should the health examination be a screen- ing or a diagnosis? Am. J. Pub. Health, 1925, 15: 1083-5.— HEALTH EXAMINATION 147 HEALTH EXAMINATION Crampton C. W. The health examination and its distinctive features. Med. J. & Rec, 1925, 121: 463-5. ------ The health examination, life service and the family doctor. N. York State J. M., 1933, 33: 1216-8.—Dewees, E. J. Technique of the periodic health examination. Week. Roster, Phila., 1935-36, 31: 965-7.—Diehl, H. S. The content and technics of periodic health examinations. In Pract. Libr. M. & S. (Appleton) N. Y., 1937, 12: 10-46.—Dunn, A. D. Discussion of and demonstration of a periodic health examination of an apparently healthy person. Nebraska M. J., 1926, 11: 460-2.— Faught, F. A. Periodic health examination work; some things 1 have learned from 15 years experience. Med. Rec, N. Y., 1939, 149: 77.—Fitz, R. Periodic health examinations as part of a medical student's curriculum. J. Am. M. Ass., 1929, 92: 1645-8. Also repr. ------ The doctor and periodic health examinations. Proc. Interst. Postgrad. M. Ass. N. America, 1936, 322-5. ----— The periodic health examination as a method of clinical investigation. J. Am. M. Ass., 1939, 112: 1115-20.—Galdston, I. Making the health examination part of office practice. J. Med., Cincin., 1933, 14: 204.—Garland, J. A handbook for health examinations by physicians. Boston M. & S. J., 1925, 192: 947-67.—Higgins, M. E. What special training should a general practitioner have to conduct satis- factorily an annual physical examination? Ann. Clin. M., 1925, 4: 293-8.—Jenney, F. L. B. General instructions to examiners. Med. Insur., 1924-25, 40: 437-49.—Jennings, C. G. The periodic health examination history taking. J. Michigan M. Soc, 1933, 32: 85-9. Also repr.—Keene, C. H. The physician considers physical fitness tests. J. School Health, 1939, 9: 185-94.—Kraus, R. Beitrag zur praventlven Medizin; Vor- schlag zur Schaffung eines Familienkatasters. Wien. med. Wschr., 1926, 76: IL—Lambert, S. W. The periodic health examination in general practice. J. Med., Cincin., 1932, 13: 588-90.—Ley, H. A., jr. Who takes the periodic health exami- nation? Proc Life Ext. Exam., 1939, 1: 17-20.—Lian, C. Unt epreuve d'aptitude aux efforts physiques; le test du pas gym- nastique sur place. Pressemed., 1940,48:385-7.—MacDonald, A. An example in preventive medicine, being a physical exami- nation by 10 specialists. West. M. Times, 1927, 47: 161-8 — Maynard, E. P., jr. The health examination and private practice. J. Med., Cincin., 1934, 15: 423.—Middleton, F. C. Periodic health examination as a public health measure. Canad. Pub. Health J., 1929, 20: 288-93— Rogers, J. F. Frequency of periodic health examinations. J. School Health, 1940, 10: 1-6.—Snow, W. B. Periodic health examinations and management of findings. Phys. Ther., 1927, 45: 125-38. --- periodic. See also Preventive medicine. American Medical Association. Periodic health examination. 2. rev. 104p. 21^cm. Chic, 1940. Covalitj, S. *Sur la necessite de l'introduction de l'examen medical periodique pour les personnes bien portantes en apparence. 39p. 8? Par., 1938. Lectures on periodic health examination. 171p. 1 1. 8? N. Y., 1925. New York. Greater New York Com- mittee on Health Examination. _ The health examination; a report of the activities and an evaluation of the results of the campaign for health examination, conducted by the Greater New York Committee on Health Examination, October 15 through December 31, 1929. 56p. 4? N. Y., 1930. Adams, J. M. Periodic health examinations. Med. Bull., N. Y., 1937-38, 3: 218-22.—Annual report of the Committee on Preventive Medicine and Periodic Health Examinations. Ohio M. J., 1934, 30: 681; 1936, 32: 1007.—Araoz Alfaro, G., & Malamud, T. El contralor peri6dico del estado e la salud. Sem. med., B. Air., 1933, 40: 812-5. Also Prensa med. argent., 1933-34, 20: 507-12.—Armstrong, D. B. Doctor and layman, and the periodic health examination. Internat. J. M. & S., 1933, 46: 570-3.—Azoulay, L. La consultation p6riodique preventive. Rev. hyg., Par., 1924, 46: 1212.—Barros Barreto, J. de. Exdmenes medicos peri6dicos. Bol. Cons. nac. hig., Montev., 1930, 25: 377-86.—Bauer, W. W. Progress in peri- odic health examination. Bull. Am. M. Ass., 1934, 29: 40-3. Bigelow, G. H. What and why is the health examination? Boston M. & S. J., 1925, 193: 1185-7.—Billings, F. Periodic medical examinations. Minnesota M., 1925, 8: 419-21.— Bloedorn, W. A. The annual physical examination. TJ. S. Nav. M. Bull., 1924, 21: 479-84. ------ The periodic health examination. Am. J. M. Sc, 1927, 173: 385-96.—Blount, W. N. Periodic examinations. South. M. J., 1933, 26: 740.— Bradbury, S. Health examination. In Cyclop. Med. (Piersol- Bortz) Phila., 1939, 7: 112-22.—Brooks, H. The periodical physical examination. Internat. Clin., 1929, 39. ser., 2: 81-97.—Bryant, B. L. Regular health examinations. N. England J. M., 1928, 199: 856.—Cannon, J. H. The annual physical examination. J. S. Carolina M. Ass., 1925, 21: 120-4.—Capps, J. A. Periodic health examinations. Wisconsin M. J., 1926, 25: 541-4.—Carter, D. W., jr. Periodic health examinations. Texas J. M., 1927-28, 13: 23-30.— Clark, O. Valor dos exames periodicos de saude ou exames medicos preventivos. Brasil med., 1932, 46: 483-6.—Cook, H. W. Periodic physical examinations. Minnesota M., 1924, 7: 777-80.—Dodson, J. M. The American Medical Association and periodic health examinations. Am. J. Pub. Health, 1925, 15: 599-601. ------ Periodic health examina- tions; the plan endorsed bv the American Medical Association. J. Missouri M. Ass., 1926, 23: 93-8. Also Bull. Ass. Am. M. Coll., 1927, 2: 124-9.------■ Health appraisals or peri- odic examinations of apparently healthy persons. Med. Insur., 1931, 47: 91; 98; 116. Also Illinois M. J., 1931, 59: 291-300.------The periodic physical examination of the apparently healthy; its development and present status. Internat. J. M. & S., 1931, 44: 197-203.—Edie, E. B. Periodic health examinations. Internat. Clin., 1924, 34. ser., 4: 91- 103.—Elliott, C. A. The periodic health examination. Proc. Interst. Postgrad. M. Ass. N. America, 1933, 79-81.—Emerson, H. Periodical health examinations. In Pract. Lect. (M. Soc. Co. Kings) 1924-26, 2. ser., N. Y., 1927; 153-62.—Faught, F. A. The periodic health examination (the exemplification of personal preventive medicine) Clin. M. & S., 1936, 43: 165-9. ------ The periodic health examination; character- istic findings after 40 years of age. Week. Roster, Phila., 1936, 31: 1491; 32: 7. Also repr.—Filippini, A. Nuovi oriz- zonti della medicina preventiva; le visite mediche periodiche. Policlinico, 1926, 33: sez. prat., 234-7.—Fisk, E. L. The opportunity of the general practitioner in the field of periodic health examination service. Long Island M. J., 1925, 19: 353-63. ------ Periodic health examinations. Memphis M. J., 1928, 5: 69-78.—Gottstein, A. Ueber die Untersuchung Gesunder. Deut. med. Wschr., 1931, 57:1733-5.—Govaerts, A. L'examen medical pr6ventif. Bruxelles med., 1925-26, 6: 1152-5.-—Griswold, M. H. The periodic health examination. Connecticut Health Bull., 1936, 50: 247-9. Also Connecticut M. J., 1940, 4: 471-4. Also repr.—Haggard, W. D. The American Medical Association and periodic health examina- tion. J. Tennessee M. Ass., 1925-26, 18: 29-32.—Hamel. Les examens medicaux preventifs en Allemagne. Bull. Off. internat. hyg. pub., Par., 1931, 23: 1245-7.—Hanson, W. S. Periodic health examinations. Texas J. M., 1930-31, 26: 482-4.—Harrison, H. M. Periodic health examination and the general practitioner. Canad. M. Ass. J., 1934, 31: 650-4. The periodic health examination from various view points. Canad. Pub. Health J., 1936, 27: 61-6. Also Med. Off., Lond., 1938, 59: 97-9.—Hines, E. A. Periodic examina- tions of apparently healthy persons. J. M. Ass. Georgia, 1927, 16: 223-8.—Hutton, J. H. Another plea for periodic health examinations. Med. Insur., 1924-25, 40: 606-8.—Kaufmann, F. Zur periodischen Untersuchung gesunder Erwerbstatiger. Schweiz. med. Wschr., 1935, 65: 784-6.—Kerr, L. The one neglected field of medical practice. Med. Times, N. Y., 1933, 61: 204.—Leber, O. The place of the periodic health examina- tion in the practice of medicine to-day. Med. J. & Rec, 1930, 132: 318-20. Also repr.—Leslie, C. J. The second periodic health examination. Proc. Life Ext. Exam., 1939, 1: 123-7.— Lissack, E. The periodic health examination. Clin. M. & S., 1930, 37: 420.—Lutrario, A. Sur les examens medicaux periodiques. Bull. Off. internat. hyg. pub., Par., 1933, 25: 1772-4.—Maclaren, J. P. Periodical health examinations. J. M. Ass. S. Africa, 1931, 5: 3-8.—May, O. Periodic medical examination. Lancet, Lond., 1925, 1: 168.—Molina Font, F., & Carranca y Trujillo, R. La prevencion de las enferme- dades por los ex&menes medicos peri6dicos. Cr6n. med. mex., 1933 32: 1-6.—Morgan, A. C. Periodic health examinations. J M. Soc. N. Jersey, 1926, 23: 221-6.—Morris, R. S. Periodic health examinations. Clifton M. Bull., 1927-28, 13: 7-11 — Myers, G. P. Periodic examinations. Indust. M., 1936, 5: 545-7.—Navarro, M. Exames medicos peri6dicos. Med. contemp., Lisb., 1939, 57: 71-6.—Neustatter, O. Gesund- heitsuntersuchungen. Miinch. med. Wschr., 1926, 73: 159-61. Also Zschr. Desinfekt., 1929, 21: 27-9.—Nurse, J. R. Louis- ville, Kentucky, Health Week chairman stresses periodic health examination. Nat. Negro Health News, 1939, 7: 5.— O'Crowley, C. R. Periodic examination of the apparently healthy. J. M. Soc. N. Jersey, 1926, 23: 66-8.—Periodical medical examination. Health, Canberra, 1936, 14: 135-7.— Perkins, W. H. The present status of the health examination. N. Orleans M. & S. J., 1937, 90: 387-92.—Pokorny, F. Ueber periodische Gesundenuntersuchung. Wien. klin. Wschr., 1940 53: 169-71.—Ponton, T. R. The periodic health ex- amination. J. Iowa M. Soc, 1928, 18: 434-7.—Reichert, J. E. Periodic examinations of the presumably healthy persons. Wisconsin M. J., 1926, 25: 57-9.—Rogers, F. R. PFI questions and answers. J. Health Phys. Educ, 1940, 11: 352—Routley, T. C. Periodic health examinations. Canad. M. Ass. J., 1939 40: 279—Shipley, A. E. Preclinical medicine. Long Island M. J., 1925, 19: 281-92.—Snell, A. M. Periodic health examinations. Minnesota M., 1927, 10: 222-7.—Spears, T. S. The periodic health examination. Colorado M., 1931, 28: 399-404 —Spencer, R. R. Periodic health examinations. Health Off., Wash., 1936-37, 1: 460-4—Sur les examens medicaux preventifs en France; d'apres les donnees recuedhes par l'Office International d'Hygiene publique. Bull. Off. internat. hyg. pub., Par., 1931, 23: 1254-64.—Thomson, A. N. A survey of the present status of the periodic health examina- tion. Am. J. Pub. Health, 1925, 15: 595-8. Also Long Island HEALTH EXAMINATION 14S HEALTH EXAMINATION M. J., 1925. 19: 293-6.—Tictze, V. Periodische iirztliche Untersuchungen Gesunder. Li :is dc salud, de farmacias y de la propaganda difundida y periodistica. Bol. san. Guate- mala, 1938, 9: 274-85.—Freeman, A. W. l'ontos fundamentaes na legislacao sanitaria. Fol. med., Rio, 1926, 7: 185.-—Lara, H. Necesidades que se podrfan tomar en cuenta para la formu- laci6n del anteproyecto del C6digo de sanidad Peruano. Rev. mid. peru., 1940, 12: 3-12.—Legislacao sanitaria. Arq. hig., S. Paulo, 1940, 5: No. 8, 169-275.—Ley de sanidad nacional. Rev. san., Caracas, 1940, 5: No. 2, 139-43.— Pruneda, A. El nuevo c6digo_^anitario. Gac. mid. Mexico, 1935-36, 66: 395-405.—Recent health legislation in Canada. Canad. Pub. Health J., 1934, 25: 524-32.—Robledo. A. Legis- laci6n vigente. Colombia mid.. 1940, 2: 184-9.—Trigueros, G. Moci6n pidiendo la unificiicion de legislaciones sanitarias de Centro America y Paii:nn:i. Bol. san. Guatemala, 1938. 9: 368-71.—Whitelaw, T. H. Hie Provincial Health Act; its merits and defects. Canad. M. Ass. J., 1916, 6: 313-20.— Ztiniga Idi&quez, M. Es de urgente necesidad que las legisla- tivas de Centro America y de Panamd proscriban la importa- ci6n, la fabricaci6n, la venta y el uso de los entretenedores y del biber6n de tubo largo. Bol. san. Guatemala, 1938, 9: 143-9. ---- America: United States. Campbell, E. R. President's annual address before the Windham County Medical Society. 7p. 8? [Bellows Falls, 1909] Chapin, C. V. Sanitary legislation in the United States enacted during the year 1906. 8p. 8? Providence, R. I., 1906. Connecticut, U. S. State Department of Health. Statutes of Connecticut relating to public health; revision of 1930; public acts of 1931. 572p. 8? Hartford, 1932. ----Physician's handbook (1935) 52p. 16? Hartford, 1935. Human, G. In the Supreme Court of Missouri: return filed in behalf of the State Board of Health of Missouri by the secretary, in the case of Hathaway v. the Board, on June 24, 1890. 3p. 8? [n. p. n. d.] 1890. Kerr, J. W., 2 HEALTH LAW Gautrez, K. Une loi necessaire; l'insalubritd publique et l'expropriation. 174p. 12? Par., 1907. Martin, A. J., & Bluzet, A. Commontairc administratif et technique de la loi du 15 fevrier 1902, relative a la protection de la sante publique. 472]). 8? Par., 1903. Moxod, H. La sante publique (legislation sanitaire de la France) 374p. 8? Par., 1904. Mosny. La protection de la sante publique; loi; commentaires de la loi; reglements d'ad- ministration. 93p. 8? Par., 1904. Moii-ette-Grangee, F. *De l'application de la loi sanitaire de 1902 dans les campagnes. 38p. 8? Par., 1908. Niepce, J. *De l'expropriation des immeubles insalubres (necessit6 de modifier la legislation franchise) [Lyon] 90p. 8? Par., 1912. Protection de la sante publique; legisla- tion. 14p. 12? Par., 1902. Protection (La) de la sante publique; 1: Loi du 15 feVrier 1902; 2: Reglement sanitaire du D£partement de la Seine. 16p. 12? Par., 1903. Sesboue, C. *Etude des mesures sanitaire? resultant de l'application de la loi du 15 fevrier 1902. 106p. 8? Par., 1902. Strauss, P., & Fillassier, A. Loi sur la protection de la sante publique (loi de 15 fevrier 1902) travaux 16gislatifs, guide pratique et commentaire. 3()fip. 12? Par., 1902. Also 2. ed. 504p. 8? Par., 1905. Avant-projet (L') de loi sanitaire. Mouvement hyg., Brux., 1910, 26: 269-86. [Belgium] Circulaire ministdrielle aux Gouverneurs de province; intervention du d6partement dans le cout des travaux d'hygii"ne et de sante publique. Bull. san. pub., Brux.. 1939, 4: 125. Bernard, L. Sur le projet de revision de la loi du 15 fevrier 1902 sur la protection de la sante publique. Ann. hvg., Par., 1921, 4. ser., 35: 65; 200; 258; 338; 368 [Discussion] 36: 23-62. Also Bull. Acad, med., Par., 1921, 3. ser., 85: 21-60 [Discussion] 110; passim. Also Rev. hyg., Par., 1921, 43: 40; 97. ------& Lacroix. Avant- projet de revision de la loi du 15 fevrier 1902 presente au Conseil sup6rieur d'hygiene publique de France. Ibid., 758-76.--Borne. Le reforme de la loi de 1902. Ibid., 1920, 42: 447 60,— Broquin-Lacombe. A propos de la revision de la loi dn 15 fevrier 1902. Ibid., 1922, 44: 297-303.—Cazeneuve, P. Sur le projet de loi portant modification de la loi du 15 fevrier 1902 relative k la protection de la sante publique. Ann. hyg., Par., 1923, n. ser., 1: 177.—Clerc, M. La loi et les reglements d'administration publique. Ibid., 1939, n. ser., 17: 197-202.—Courmont, P. Application r6gionale des lois d'hygiene (k propos de la reforme de la loi de 1902) Bull. Aead. med., Par., 1921, 3. ser., 85: 271-5.—Delon, A. Des difficulty d'application des lois sur l'hygiene publique (r^formes k introduire dans la legislation) Rev. hyg., Par.,' 1923, 45: 74-83.—Drouineau, G. La revision de la loi du 15 fevrier 1902; les Conseils d;hygiene. Ibid., 1921, 43: 173-8.—Faivre, P. Rapport au sujet du projet de revision de la loi du 15 ffrvrier 1902. Ibid., 694-712. ------■ Projet de revision de la loi de 1902 sur la protection de la sant6 publique. Rev. prat. hyg. mun., Par., 1921, 17: 194-212.—France. Loi du 3 avril 1936 modifiant le paragraphe IV de l'article 25 de la loi du 15 ffrvrier 1902 sur la protection de la sant6 publique, modifil par les lois des 29 Janvier 1906, 25 novembre 1908 et 19 di- cembre 1921, relative k la composition du Conseil supeiieur d'hygiene publique de France. Bull. Min. san. pub., Par., 1936, 105.— ------ Reglement sanitaire departemental (abridgement) Techn. san. mun., Par., 1937, 32: 130-8.— ------ Voeu adopt6 par le Parti social de la sante publique pour que les lois d'hygiene soient imposes au public avec autant d'inflexibiht6 que les lois fiscales. Rev. hyg Par 1939, 61: 219.—Hayem, Roux [et al.] Du rapport de M. Leon' Bernard, sur le projet de revision de la loi du 15 fevrier 1902, sur le protection de la sante publique. Bull. Acad med ' Par., 1921, 3. ser., 85: 603-8 [Discussion]— Holtzmanii! Rapport sur la legislation d'hygiene sociale en Alsace et en Lorraine. Gaz. med. Strasbourg, 1921, 78: No. 31 (Hyg Salub.) 30.— Ichok, G. Revue de la legislation d'hygiene Rev. hyg Par., 1929, 51: 123-34. ---~— La legislation sanitaire de la France. Ibid., 1930, 52: 922-31. ______ La quatorzieme legislature et la sant6 publique. Ibid., 1932, 54: 614-26. ------ La legislation sanitaire de la France! Ibid., 1933, 55: 222. ------ La notion de l'obligation dans la protection de la sante publique. Biol, med., Par., 1937, ?7: \27~?°- ~~,---- La legislation francaise de l'hygiene de la medecine et de 1 assistance en 1938. Ann. hyg., Par., 1939 n. ser., 17: 203; 255.—Laruelle, L. Avant-projet'de loi sani- taire. Mouvement hyg , Unix., 1910, 26: 185.—Loi sanitaire. Ibid., 1912, 28: 133-13. Marrhoux. La reforme de la loi de 1902. Rev. hyg., Par., 1920, 42: 374-6.—Mercier, V. Sur la jurisprudence p. Progr., 1933 14:61-3__ Highway (The) hostess. Trained Nutse, 1941. 107: 118__ Hilbert, H. Public-health nursing in maternal and child- health services. Child, Wash., 1938, 3: 123-6.- Hubbard, R Nursing with a public health agency. Proc Nat Leag Nurs E£U^ W w1:,,I1t22--HudSon- H- Aftery rfcoveryi what? Pub. Health Nurs., 1938, 30: 655-7.—Joannon. P Du role des infirmieres dites polyvalentes dans la er offentliche Arzt und die offentliche Gesundheitspnege. OefT. < iesundhpfl., 1922, 7: 1-14 — Huber, E. G. Administrative functions of a health officer. Illinois Health Mess., 1937, 9: 33-7. Hutchinson, J. A. The duties and difficulties of a medical officer of health. Bull, san., Montreal, 1908, 8: No. 8-12, 35-40 — Hutchinson, W. The physician as a pioneer. J. Sociol. Med., Easton, Pa., 1915, 16: 357-9.—Israel. Dreissig Jahre Tatigkeit als Medizinalbe- amter. Zschr. Medbeamte, 1922, 35: 165-74.—Kerr, J. W. The need of full-time health officers. J. Am. M. Ass., 1915, 65: 1595-7 — McCullough, J. W. S. Full-time health officers. Am. J. Pub. Health, 1924, 14: 188-96. Also Canada Lancet Pract., 1925, 65: 240-6.—Marquis, E. L'action sociale des officiers de sant6. Rev. mid. hyg. trop., Par., 1933, 25: 73.— Mohr. C. A. The citv health officer; his functions and duties. Tr. M. Ass. Alabama, 1915, 404-16.—Mountin. J. W. The legitimate field of the health officer. Illinois Health Q., 1931, 3: 62-70.—Pecori, G. Le funzioni dell'ufficiale sanitario: i suoi rapporti con i medici privati e con le autoriti municipali. Italia san.. 1924, 16: No. 12, 3-5.—Ross, G. Is the health officer fulfilling his responsibility in relation to the nursing program'.' Am. J. Pub. Health, 1939, 29: 305-17.—Rowntree, G. R. The health officer's duties and responsibilities. Bull. Bd Health Kentucky, 1934, 7: 5.—Sanders, C. The pubhc health service as a career. Med. Off., Lond., 1917, 18: 77.— Sarganek. Sieben und zwanzig Jahre Tatigkeit als Medizinal- beamter. Zschr. Medbeamte, 1921, 34: 409-20.—Schrader. Zukunftsaufgaben amtsarztlicher Tatigkeit. Ibid., 1922, 35: 372-5.- -Seymour, G. The relation of health officers and social worker^. Proc. Nat. Conf. Social Work, 1917, 44: 246-51 — Stekhoven.. [Public Health Officer as a physician and official] tiei.ee. k. dds, 1934, 12: 847-52—W'eis,'E. W. The local health officer and his problems. Illinois M. J., 1919, 36: 131-4.—Wilbur, R. L. The health officer as an educator. Proc Conf. Health Author. N. America. 1931, 46: 15-9.— Willoughby, H. The work of a port health officer. J. R. Nav M. Serv., 1930, 16: 256-60.—Wolman, A. The public health engineer and the city health officer. Am. J. Pub. Health 1941 31: 435-9. ---- Congresses, and societies. See also Hygiene, public, Congresses. Conference of Health Authorities of North America. Proceedings. Wash., 15. meet., 1900- Confeuencia Panamericana de directores nacionales de sanidad. Adas de la tercera conferencia. 396p. 8°. Wash., D. C, 1936. Ontario. Association of Executive Health Officers of Ontario. Reports of the annual meetings. v.2; 4 -18. 8? Toronto, 1887-1903. Tennessee. State Department of public health. Transactions of the annual conference of health officers. Nashville, 1-5. conf., 1927-32; 9. conf., 1937; 10. conf., 1938. Annual conference of state and local health officials. Pub. Health News, Trenton, 1939, 23: 3.—April (The) conferences of health officials in Washington. Health Off., Wash., 1937, 2: 8-21.—Association (The) and public health medical officers. Brit. M. J., 1935, 1: 1127.—Baxter, A. C. Introductory address delivered at the conference of Illinois health officers and public health nurses, Springfield, November 30, 1938. Illinois Health Mess., 1939, 11: 19.—Conference of State and Provincial Health Authorities of North America in joint session with Pan-American Conference of National Directors of Health; program. Proc. Conf. Health Author. N. America, 1940, 55. meet., 7-12.—Congress of public health physicians (Berlin) J. Am. M. Ass., 1938, 111: 1483.—Cuarta conferencia panameri- cana de directores nacionalcs de sanidad, celebrada en Washing- ton, D. G, abril 30-mayo 8, 1940. Bol. Of. san. panamer., 1940, 19: 535; portr., 649. Also Bol. educ. san., Caracas, 1940, 3: No. 63, 2.—Georgia physicians and health officials study together. J. Am. M. Ass., 1939, 112: 632.—Griffin, R. B. Staff conferences in a full-time county health depart- ment. Rep. Conf. Tennessee Health Work., 1932, 5: [Dis- cussion] 30-0.—Health officers meet at San Diego. Week. Bull. California Dep. Pub. Health, 1940-41, 19: 137.—Hor- vath, D. [Proceedings of the 3rd meeting of the chief county public health officers of Hungary] Orsz. Kozegeszs. Int. kozl., 1932, 5: No. 5, 25-45.—Huber, K. Die Arbeiten der Schweizerischen Sanitatsdirektorenkonferenz 1919-39. Bull. Eidg. Gesundhamt., 1940, Beil., 492; 512; 540.------& Brun, S. Achtzehnte Sanitatsdirektoren- Konferenz; Protokoll. Ibid., 1935, Beil. 25, 1-60.—Joint conference of provincial health ministers and Dominion Council of Health. Nat. Health Rev., Ottawa, 1939, 7: 31-3 — Lloyd, B. J. Conferencia de directores de sanidad de los estados y provincias de Norte-Am6rica. Bol. Of. san. pan- amer., 1935, 14: 741-5.------Third Pan American Con- ference of National Directors of Health. Bull. Panamer. Union, 1936. 70: 461-4. Also Mil. Surgeon, 1936, 78: 427-38.— Nineteenth annual conference of state and territorial health authorities with the United States Public Health Service. Pub. Health Bull., Wash., 1921, No. 119, 11-51, ch.—Osborn, S. H. Committee on Federal Relations, State and Provincial Health Authorities. Tr. Conf. State Terr. Health Off., 1940, Spec, 180.—Primera (La) reuni6n del personal t6cnico de loa servicios de paludismo, tracoma y anquilostomiasis del norte del pais. Bol. san., B. Air., 1938, 2: 39-55.—Program, officers, members; fifty-third Annual Conference of state and provincial health authorities of North America, Washington, 1938. Proc. Conf. Health Author. N. America, 1938, 53: 9; 168 — Report on the meeting of directors of institutes and schools of hygiene held at Geneva from November 22d to 27th, 1937. BuU. Health Org. League of Nat., 1938, 7: 169-90.—[Report of the first congress of rural district public health doctors of Socialistic Ukraine] Radianska med., 1939, 4: No. 2, 7-9.— Resolutions [of the Fifth annual conference of Tennessee Health workers, 1932] Rep. Conf. Tennessee Health Work., 1932, 5: 245.—Resoluciones y recomendaciones de la IV. conferencia panamericana de directores nacionales de sanidad, celebrada en Washington, D. C, del 30 de abril al 8 de mayo de 1940. Gac. med. Mexico, 1940, 70: 428-32.—Society (The) of Medical Officers of Health. Pub. Health, Lond., 1922-23, 36: 201; 1937-38, 51: 23.—State and territorial health officers confer on health defenses. Pub. Health Rep., Wash., 1941, 56: 1194-217.—Tercera conferencia Panameri- cana de directores nacionales de sanidad y sesi6n ejecutiva del consejo directivo de la Oficina sanitaria panamericana; cele- brada en la Union panamericana, Washington, D. C, abril 4-15, 1936. Reforma mid., Lima, 1936, 22: 347; 354. Also Actas Conf. panamer. dir. nac. san., Wash., 1936, 3: 23-7. Also Bol. Of. san. panamer., 1936, 15: 413-24. Also Bol. san., B. Air., 1937, 1: 5-14. Also Pub. Health Rep., Wash., 1936, 51, 21: 645-55.—Thirty-eighth (The) annual conference of State and Territorial Health Officers. Ibid., 1940, 55: 900 — Transactions of the twenty-seventh annual conference of state and territorial health officers with the United States Public- Health Service. Pub. Health Bull., Wash., 1930, No. 194, 3:-5: 1-117.—Transactions of the Thirty-Seventh Annual Confer- ence of State and Territorial Health Officers with the Public Health Service. Tr. Conf. State Terr. Health Off., 1939, 37: 1-17.—Troisi&me (La) Conference Panam§rieaine des direc- teurs nationaux d'hygiene, tenue k Washington du 4 au 15 avril 1936. Bull. Serv. hyg., Port-au-Prince, 1936, 3: No. 10, HEALTH OFFICER 159 HEALTH OFFICER 14-28.—Walker, H. H. How to maintain interest in health worker's conferences. Papers Health Work. Conf. Tennessee, 1937, 9: [Discussion] 160-6. --- Directory. Annual conference of state and terri- torial HEALTH AUTHORITIES WITH THE PUBLIC Health and Marine Hospital Service, Wash- ington, June 1, 1912. A list of the state and insular health authorities of the United States. 14p. 8? Wash., 1912. Repr. from Pub. Health Rep. No. 83. List (A) of the state and insular health authorities of the United States. 14p. 8? Wash., 1913. Repr. from Pub. Health Rep. No. 123. State and Insular health authorities. 24p. 8? Wash., 1914. Repr. from Pub. Health Rep. No. 190. City health officers, 1917-38; directory of those in cities of 10,000 or more population. Pub. Health Rep., Wash., 1917, 32: 1221; 1918, 33: 2095; 1921, 36: 2543; 1922, 37: 1642; 1923, 38: 2415; 1924, 39: 1444; 1927, 42: 2246; 1937, 52: 182; 1938, 53: 1783.—Directory of whole-time county health officers, 1937-40. Ibid., 1937, 52: 1667; 1938, 53: 1147; 1939, 54: 1923; 1941, 56: 10.—Dittrick, H. Cleveland health officers. Bull. Acad. M. Cleveland, 1934, 18: No. 9, 6-12.— Executive health officers of states and territories of the United States, of the Provinces of the Dominion of Canada, and Newfoundland 1938-39. Proc. Conf. Health Author. N. America, 1938, 53. meet., 166; 1939, 54. meet. 109; 1940, 55. meet., 147.—Health officers of the State of California by counties. Week. Bull. California Dep. Pub. Health, 1936, 15: 89; 1937, 16: 69.—Health officers of the State of California by counties July 1, 1939. Ibid., 1939-40, 18: 101-3.—State and insular health authorities, 1916-38; directory, with data as to appropriations and publications. Pub. Health Rep., Wash., 1916, 31: 1525; 1917, 32: 1020; 1918, 33: 1770; 1931, 46: 2899; 1933, 48: 1516; 1938, 53: 1408.—Whole-time county health officers, 1927. Ibid., 1927. 42: 1576-81. ---- Education, and qualification. Aspirants for the pubhc health service. Med. Off., Lond., 1939, 62: 91.—Casagrandi, O. La preparazione dei medici igienisti. Italia san., 1923, 15: No. 23, 3-7.—City health officers, 1936; directory of those in cities of 10,000 or more population. Pub. Health Rep., Wash., 1936, 51: 1575-92 — Degrees and diplomas in public health. Med. Off., Lond., 1940, 64: 78-84.—Derryberry, M., & Caswell, G. Qualifica- tions of professional public health personnel; health officers and other medical personnel. Pub. Health Rep., Wash., 1940, 55: 2377-96.—Earp, J. R. The indifference of our medical schools to careers in pubhc health. J. Am. M. Ass., 1937, 108: 63.—Educational qualifications of health officers. Am. J. Pub. Health, 1939, 29: 787; 1342.—Examination for appoint- ment to U. S. Pubhc Health Service. Ibid., 112: 253 — Ferrell, J. A. Measures for increasing the supply of competent health officers. Ibid., 1921, 77: 513-7. ------ Professional- ization in public health service. Proc. Congr. M. Educ, 1933, 16-9. Also repr.—Fraser, D. T. Special or post-graduate public health training. Brit. M. J., 1930, 2: 634-6— Frost, W. H. Authoritative standards and association policy. In his Papers, N. Y., 1941, 562-73.—Geiger, J. C. The training of health officers. Am. J. Pub. Health, 1930, 20: 1055-64.— Godfrey, E. S., jr. Education and training of the physician for a pubhc health career. Ibid., 1940, 30: 1447-51.—Green- wood, M. The education of pubhc health officers. Med. Off., Lond., 1930, 44: 181-5.—Gregg, A. Some essentials in training for pubhc health. Am. J. Pub. Health, 1939, 29: 1308-12. Also Diplomate, 1940, 12: 190-4— Helbich, B. [Recent criticism of insufficiency of ranking officers in sanitary profession] Vest. desk, lek., 1926, 38: 679.—Illing. L, Die Vorbildung fiir den arztlichen Staatsdienst. Zschr. Med- beamte, 1927, 40: 537-48.—Informe de la comisi6n sobre calificaciones para funcionarios y otro personal sanitario. Bol. Of. san. panamer., 1936, 15: 652-9.—Johan, B. [Educa- tion of public health officers] Orsz. K6zeg6szs. Int. kozle- menyei, 1927-28, 1: No. 4, 1-19. ------ The training of physicians for pubhc health service in Hungary. Orvosk6pzes, 1935, 25: mar. kiilonf. Educ. med., 332; 340.—Kenwood, H. R. The teaching and training in hygiene; some criticisms and suggestions; the training of the medical public health worker. Lancet, Lond., 1918, 1: 695-9.—Knowles, M., & Scharff, M. R. New specifications for health officers. Am. J. Pub. Health, 1920, 10: 8-13.—Lamer, H. B. Common-sense versus custom in the appointment of health officials. Ibid., 1921, 11: 143-5.—London, Society of Medical Officers of Health. The qualifications, recruitment, training and pro- motion of local government officers; memorandum of evidence submitted by the Society of Medical Officers of Health to the Departmental Committee. Pub. Health, Lond., 1930-31, 44: 212-29.—McCombs, C. E., & Lewinski-Corwin, E. H. The training of physicians for pubhc health service. Med. Rec, N. Y., 1918, 94: 319-24.— McCormack, J. N. The funda- mental knowledge necessary for health officers. South. M J 1920, 13: 498-501.— Meleney, H. E. Certain criteria in the qualifications and preparation of health officers. Am. J. Pub Health, 1938, 28: 423-9.—Miller, K. E. Leadership in public health work. Health Off., Wash., 1936-37, 1: 196-205.— Mountin, J. W. A plan for training county health officers. J. Am. M. Ass., 1928, 91: 717-20.—Nuttall, G. H. F. The training and status of public health officer.s in the United Kingdom. Tr. Internat. Congr. Hyg. Demogr., 1912, 15. Congr., 4: 417-35. Also repr.—Olsen, R. Como se puede apreciar la eficiencia de los funcionarios de sanidad local. Bol. pan- amer. san., 1923, 2: 155-7.—Parran, T., jr. Opportunities for the young physician in the United States Public Health Service. Am. Interne, 1936, 2: No. 5, 4-9.—Paterson, J. J. The instructional course for health officers in Austria. Med. Off., Lond., 1923, 29: 201; passim.—Petres, A. [Training of public health officers at the Johns Hopkins University] Nep- egeszsegugy, 1939, 20: 735-42.—Prausnitz, C. Dersozial- medizinische Unterricht der staathchen und kommunalen Medizinalbeamten. Zschr. Krankenpfl., 1920, 42: 520.— Public health fellowships available to qualified applicants from other American republics. J. Am. M. Ass., 1941, 116: 313.—Rucker, W. C. Competent health officers, a cooperative plan for obtaining officers having a given standard of training. Pub. Health Rep., Wash., 1916, 31: 763.—Schleier. Mittei- lungen der Wissenschaftlichen Gesellschaft der deutschen Aerzte des offentlichen Gesundheitsdienstes; Bericht iiber die Fortbildungstagung der Medizinalbeamten und vollbeschaf- tigten Hilfsarzte im Bereich der Gruppe Schlesien am 12. und 13. V. 1939 in Breslau. Oeff. Gesundhdienst, 1939-40, 5: A, 571.—Sears, F. W. Schools for health officers; what has been done at Syracuse. Am. J. Pub. Health, 1920, 10: 155-9.— Smillie, W. G. Preliminary field training for the health officer. South. M. J., 1927, 20: 567-71.—Smirnov, S. D. [Insufficient preparation of sanitary physicians, and the necessity for establishing hygienic faculties] Vest. obsh. hig. sudeb. prakt. med., 1909, 45: 858-65.—State and insular health authorities, 1936; directory, with data as to appropria- tions and publications. Pub. Health Rep., Wash., 1936, 51: 1460-78.—Training of the public health officer. South. M. J., 1938, 31: 820.—Whipple, G. C. The education of health officers. Internat. J. Pub. Health, Geneve, 1921, 2: 263; 337. Also Pub. Health Rep., Wash., 1921, 36: 2593-622.—Williams, J. W., jr. Age limit for public health officers raised. J. Mis- souri M. Ass., 1941, 38: 183. ---- Legal aspect. Loir, L. A. *Notions de droit administratif a l'usage du medecin fonctionnaire d'hygiene [Paris] 143p. 8? Lille, 1933. Barlow, T. W. N. The status of the Medical Officer of Health in relation to the Ministry of Health. Pub. Health, Lond., 1916-17, 30: 223-5.—Gray, K. G. Legal responsi- bility of a medical officer of health. Canad. Pub. Health J., 1937, 28: 235-40.—Hope, E. W. Discussion on the training for the D. P. H. and the new regulations. Brit. M. J., 1922, 2: 363-5.—Jorns. Sind die Medizinalbeamten den ubrigen hoheren Beamten gleichgestellt? Zschr. Medbeamte, 1924, 37: 41-51.—Michigan Supreme Court defines the powers and limitations of health officers. Illinois M. J., 1923, 44: 81.— New public health decoration [France] J. Am. M. Ass., 1938, 110: 1296.—Petrina, A. Zur Frage der privaten Betatigung des arztlichen Berufes von Seite der Amtsarzte. Amtsarzt, Lpz., 1918, 10: 98-100.—Power to quarantine, but jail not proper place (Dowling, Health Officer, v. Harden (Ala.) 88 So. R. 217) J. Am. M. Ass., 1921, 77: 1598.—Preliminary report of Committee on the Standardization of the Work of Public Health Officials. Am. J. Pub. Health, 1917, 7: 771-5.— Robinson, D. Liability of a city for acts committed by its officers in enforcing health laws. Pub. Health Rep., Wash., 1920, 35: 1039-43.—Sand, R. Que peut faire le Ministere de la sant6 publique? Bull. Min. san. pub., Brux., 1938, 3: 145-58.—Sanitari (I) comunali; il loro stato giuridico e le loro attribuzioni. Rass. clin. sc, 1937, 15: 441-5.—Wilson, A. The authority of the medical officer of health in his community. Canad. Pub. Health J., 1929, 20: 167-71. ---- Office work, and procedures. Forbes, R. P. Health record. 48p. 8? Bost. [1929] Geiger, J. C Health officers' manual. 148p. 20cm. Phila., 1939. Walker, W. F., & Randolph, C R. Re- cording of local health work. 275p. 4? N. Y., 1935. Craster, C. V. The health officer and the enforcement of the law. Am. J. Pub. Health, 1919, 9: 362-6. Also Med. Insur., 1918-19, 28: 308-11.—Dean. J. O., & Henderson, M. C. Simplification of records through an analysis of procedures. Am. J. Pub. Health, 1941, 31: 709-14.—Emerson, H. A standard budget; the health officer's first need. Ibid., 1920, 10: 221-3.—Frost, W. H. Rendering account in public health. In his Papers, N. Y„ 1941, 553-61.—Hanson, M. C. Public HEALTH OFFICER 160 HEALTH OFFICER relation- ..f health officers. Illinois Health Mess., 1940, 12: 35-7.- Holmes. W. 11.. jr. Preparation and use of maps and graphic rhaii.-. in sanitation work. Rep. Conf. Tennessee Health Work., 1932, 5: [Discussion] 190-6.—Laureck, M. Das Formular- und Statistikenwesen in der kommunalen 'lesundheitsfi'irsorge. Zschr. Schulgesundh., 1928, 41: 11-6.— Mandy, I. [ Periodical health reports] N6peg6szs6gugy, 1937, 18: 941- I. — Mouniin, J. W.( & Pennell, E. H. Tenure of office for h.alth cUb-ris. Am. J. Pub. Health, 1938, 28: 1311- 8.- Ratzefcld, V. S. [Basic principles in organizing prophy- lactic work in an area] Profil. med., Kharkov, 1927, 6: No. 3, 119-30.—Renon, L. L'alliance de l'hygiene et de la pathologie dans la medecine preventive: l'examen sanitaire rigulier et systematique. Bull. Acad, med., Par., 1921, 3. ser., 86: 31C-8. ------ L'examen sanitaire rfigulier et systematique dans la medecine preventive. Gaz. hop., 1921, 94: 1205.—Round table discussion of problems and ideas for making record handling easier. Papers Health Work. Conf. Tennessee, 1938, 10: 160.—Savard, E. M. A. L'aide que l'inspection r£gionale est appel6e k donner aux municipalites. Bull. mid. Quebec, 1918-19, 20: 77-84.—Smith, W. G. Psychology and public health. Pub. Health J., Toronto, 1918, 9: 106-8.—Swarts, G. T. Charts and maps as used by health officers. Am. J. Pub. Health. 1918, 8: 674-89. Also repr.—Vaughan, H. F. Recent advance- in administrative technics. Ibid., 1936, 26: 1198-203. -Welch. S. W. Report of a State health officer South. M. .1.. 1919, 12: 310-3.—What should be the relation- ship between state health officers and the service in regard to the investigative activities of the service? Pub. Health Bull., Wash., 192L No. 139, 98-120.—Wilson, H., & Savage, S. W. Psychology in relation to public health. Pub. Health, Lond., 1935-36, 49: 203-13. ---- Personal needs, and compensation. Barlow, T. W. N. The Public Health Service as a career. Med. Off., Lond., 1923, 30: 101-3.—Barsoukov, M. [On scaling wages of medico-sanitai \ administrators upon a rational basis] Beloruss. med. dumka, 1927, 3: No. 3-5, 3 8.—Born- traeger. Selbstschutz der Medizinalbeamten. Zschr. Med- beamte, 1921, 34: 281-306.— Briceno Rossi. A. L. Por la carrera sanitaria. Bol. Min. san., Caracas, 1937-38. 2: 1109- L—Bygott, A. H. Payment of grants to local sanitary authori- ties for efficient service. J. R. San. Inst., 1914-15, 36: 98-104.— Clark, R. V. The public health service as a career. Med. Off., Lond., 1934, 52: 85.—Diehl, H. S. .Medical careers in public health. Diplomate, 1941. 13: 121-5.—Ferrell. J. A. Com- pensation of health officers. Am. J. Pub. Health, 1920, 10: 569-75. ------ Careers in public health service. J. Am. M. Ass., 1921, 7G: 489-92.—Greenwood, A. The public health service as a career for medical men. Hospital, Lond., 1908, 44: 601.—Hill, T. E. The pubhc health service as a career. Med. Off., Lond., 1922, 28: 97-9.—Howard-Jones, J. The pubhc health service as a career. Ibid., 1928. 40: 89.—Howarth, W. J. The Public Health service as a career. Ibid., 1921, 26: 99.—Kenwood, H. R. The public health medical service as a career. Ibid., 1918, 20: 77.—Lyster, R. A., & Nicoll, M.. jr. The public health service as a career. Ibid., 1924, 32: i07-9.— Minimum salaries for medical officers of local authorities; recommendations for submission to annual representative meeting of the British Medical Association. Ibid., 1920, 23: 175.—Nash, E. H. T. The public health service as a career. Ibid., 1938, 60: 101-3.—Porter, C. The public health service as a career. Ibid., 1933, 50: 95.—Report of the Committee on salary standards. Am. J. Pub. Health, 1922, 12: 693-701.— Salaries of medical officers of health. Brit. M. J., 1919, 1: 784.—Scale of salaries for the Public Health Service. Med. Off., Lond., 1922, 28: 281-3.—Solbrig. Die Verwaltungsge- buh»enordnung in Preussen. Zschr. Medbeamte, 1924, 37: 51-5.—Ward. E. The pubhc health service as a career. Med Off., Lond., 1936, 56: 97.—Wheatley, J. The Public Health Service as a career. Ibid., 1927, 37: 103. ---- Relation to the practitioner. Baker, J. N. Medical co-operation with the public health profession. J. M. Ass. Alabama, 1937-38, 7: 230-6. A plea for greater unity between the medical and pubhc health professions. Texas J. M., 1939-40, 35: 635-40.—Bushong, G. W. The health officer's view of the relation between the' health officer and the practicing physician. Kentucky M. J. 1933, 31: 329-31.—Cairns, A. A. The relationship between the division of medical inspection and the physician Penn- sylvania M. J., 1915-16, 19: 617-21.—Cumming, H.'s. Re- lation between the general practitioner and the pubhc health official. J. M. Soc. N. Jersey, 1933, 30: 599-604.—Desjardins °- *?• Des rapports du medecin de Sante avec la profession medicale. I nion med. Canada, 1922, 51: 338-47.—Du Pre Le J*0"*/ JJ-. ,TheTrel*ti°n of the general practitioner to the health official. J. R. San. Inst., 1938-39, 59: 168-71 — Fishbein M. The physician and public health officialdom Am J. Pub. Health, 1933, 23: 1223-31. Also Med Off Lond 1934, 51: 15; 25— Goddard, C. E. Some considerations for the closer co-ordination of the work of the health officer and the medical profession. J. State M., Lond. 1936 44- 57o-9.—Harbison J. A Discussion on the relations of the medical officer of health and the general profession. Med Press & Circ. Lond., 1934, 189: 29.—Jones, E. A. The prac- titioner and the deputy state health officer. Bull Med Chir Fac. Maryland, 1917-18, 38-42.—Levy, E. C. Reciprocity between the health officials and the medical profession. Am. J. Pub. Health, 1923, 13: 989-9L- Pecori, G. Le funzioni dell'ufficiale sanitario; i suoi rapporti con i medici privati e con le autoritd, municipali. Ann. igiene, 1924, 34: 190-5.— Picken, R. M. F. The changing relations between the medical officer of health and the medical profession. Pub. Health, Lond., 1938-39, 52: 261 5. Robertson. J. D. The health officer's challenge to the general practitioner. Am. J. Pub. Health, 1923, 13: 1-5.—What is the present relationship between health officers and practicing physicians, and what reciprocal relations should be brought about? Pub. Health Bull., Wash., 1924, No. 139, 137-41.—Winslow, P. V. The relation of the practicing physician to the health officer. Albany M. Ann., 1916, 37: 17-20.—Young, W. H. The health officer and the general practitioner. J. Kansas M. Soc, 1933, 34: 457-9. ---- rural, and county. Altman, G. G. The different phases of work to be done by whole-time countv health officer and county organizer. South. M. J., 1918, 11: 675-8.—Bishop, E. L. The sanitary officer and county health work. J. Am. M. Ass., 1926, 87: 645 [Discussion] 648-50.—Cope, J. Q. The need of a county health officer. J. Missouri M. Ass., 1916, 13: 542-6.—Doan, W. Some experiences of a rural M. O. H. in enforcing the Public Health Act. Canada Lancet, 1917-18, 51: 11-7.—Grote, C. A. County medical authorities; their functions and duties. Tr. M. Ass. Alabama, 1915, 399-403.—Harbison, J. A. The advent of the county medical officer of health. Irish J. M. Sc, 1932, 6: 145-9.—Reppard, M. M. The difficulties of a county health officer. Pub. Health Michigan, 1918, 6: 433-6 — Williams, L. R. The role of the health officer in populous ami rural communities. In Nelson Loose-Leaf Med., N. Y., 1920, 7: 129-34. ---- in various countries. Reece, R. J. Report to the local government board on the appointment of the medical officer of health, and on sanitary circumstances and administration of the Borough of Gravesend. 32p. 8? Lond., 1909. ----Report to the local government board on the sanitary circumstances and administra- tion of the Williton Rural District, with special reference to the appointment of medical officer of health. 23p. 8? Lond., 1910. A. W. W. The Omdeh; a public health officer. J. Egypt. M. Ass., 1934, 17: 659.—Anderson, R. A. Notes on the appoint- ment of a Deputy Assistant Director of Medical Services (Sanitary) of a division (or district) in India. J. R. Army M. Corps, 1921, 37: 211-3.—Armstrong, W. G. The first Aus- tralian health officer. Med. J. Australia, 1939, 1: 928 — Aylett, S. O. Medical officer in France. Med. Press & Circ, Lond., 1940, 204: 493-8.—Benitez S., A. Bases para la crea- ci6n de la carrera de medicos legistas e higienistas de Chile. Rev. crim., B. Air., 1929, 16: 12-6— Circolare del Ministero dellinterno; concorsi per il Servizio di ufficiale sanitario. Italia san., 1908, 4: 164.—Donahoe, W. E. The county health officer in South Dakota. J. Lancet, 1935,55:245-8.—Fagerlund, L. W. State sanitary officers of Aland. Fin. lak. sail, hand., 1935, 78: 178-87— Freeman, A. W. A profissao sanitaria nos Lstados TJrudos. Fol. med., Rio, 1926, 7: 133.—Gal, S. [Proposals for the reorganization of the administrative work of public health officers] Nepegeszsegugy, 1939, 20: 599-604.— Gilkes, H. A. Native customs in Africa and the medical officer. Tr. R. Soc. Trop. M. Hyg., Lond., 1933, 27: 315-20— Grote, ^' , f,uUTtime health officer work in Walker County (Ala.) South. M. J. 1915, 8: 1058-61.—Gutt, A. Die Bedeutung der neuen Bestallungsordnung fiir die Aerzte des offentlichen Gesundheitsdienstes. Oeff. Gesundhdienst, 1939-40, 5: A, ?f°T7.—Hoche. Preussische Medizinalbeamtenfragen. Zschr. Medbeamte 1921, 34: 329-36.—Ministry of health promotions. t a *t\1940, 1= 779.—New pubhc health workers assigned. J. Am. M. Ass., 1941, 117: 467.—New staff of outdoor medical officers of the Ministry of Health. Brit. M. J., 1920, 1: 407.— IneoW „-^eijealth officer. J. Florida M. Ass., 1940-41, 27: to Ta% ™ «Der Medizinalrat. Zschr. Medbeamte, 1926, tV a ,7^Pub,ic health service needs physicians. J. Am. M. Ass., 1936, 106: 391.—Smith, C. E. County health officers in Minnesota. J. Lancet, 1920, 40: 663-5.—Spranger. Ab- scniedsrede des Reichsgesundheitsfiihrers vor den Aerzten Berlins. Deut, med. Wschr., 1939, 65: 1055-7—Tevfik saglam [Ke-instatement of General Inspector of Hygiene ur a. Alokayin] Askeri sihhiye mecmuasi, 1941, 70: L— rhompson S. E. L. The public health officer and his relation in Pono cc ,,4li m 9ntari°- Pub. Health J., Toronto, 1919, 10: 39376—United States (The) PubUc Health Service as a career, information for persons desiring to enter the regular ^oT^f10?,6'1 Corps-, Pub- Health Rep., Wash., 1930, 45: I uu44- V acancies during wartime in the whole-time public H™i 8K71Cif- ,£nt- ^ J- tV9-4,0' 1: 61.-Vacancies in whole- time pubhc health service. Ibid., 79. HEALTH OFFICER 161 HEALTH ORGANIZATION HEALTH officers' bulletin. Albany, N. Y., v.1-4, 1920-23. v.l, Nos. 5-7, 1920 missing. HEALTH ORGANIZATION [by locali- ties] See also under names of cities, counties, and countries; also names of health agencies as Baltimore, Md. Department of health; also in 2. series, Hygiene, public: Laws, organiza- tion and progress by localities. (Note.—The following list does not contain publications of boards of health discussing special topics such as tuberculosis, water supply, &c] Aird, D. *De sanitate in India Occidentali tuenda. 51p. 8? Edinb., 1805. Boyce, R. W. Health progress and adminis- tration in the West Indies. 328p. 8? N. York, 1910. New York, N. Y. Milbank Memorial Fund. Policies and procedures in public health: proceedings of the annual conference of the Advisory Council of the Milbank Memorial Fund held on March 27 and 28, 1935, at the New York Academy of Medicine. 115p. 8? N. Y., 1935'. Acosta Ortiz, P., £cm. B Air., 1940. ---- Revista de la sanidad militar. B. Air 1-7; 1899-1905; 13; 1914- Argentina. Obras sanitarias de la na- ci6x. Boletin de ... B. Air., 1, 1937- Acuna, P. S. Las corporaciones medicas y los servicios sanitarios en las comunas. In his Un rimero d. verd 2 ed B. Air., 1938, 28-30.—Arfioz Alfaro, G., & Alvarez, F. "Report' Tr. Internat. San. Conf. Am. Repub., 1911, 5. Conf., 77-80.— Colocacion de la piedra fundamental del nuevo edificio de la Administraci6n sanitaria y asistencia publica. Rev med B. Air., 1940, 2: 790-800.^Ferreira, C. Relatorio apresantado a Directono Oeral do Servico Sanitario. Arch, lat amer pediat., B. Air., 1920, 2. ser., 14: 385; 481; 1922, 16: 720 — Guerrero, M. Mar del Plata y sus obras sanitarias. Bol obiti.- san. nac, B. .Air., 1937, 568-83.—Imbeaux, E. Nou- veaux progres de l'hygiene urbaine dans la Republiciue Argen- tine. Rev. hyg., Par., 1936, 58: 22-38- Martone, F J En pro de la unificacion de los servicios de -anidad; ncopila- ci6n de antecedentes legislatives, nacionales y extranjeros que hacen a la esencia de este trabajo. Sem. med., B Air 1939 46: 565-91.—Nuevas (Las) autoridades del Departamento nacional de lmiiene. Bol. san., B. Air., 1939, 3: 437 portr — Pinero Garcia, P. P. La estadfstica en la orientacion de la polltica sanitaria. Prensa mid. argent., 1940, 27: 657-87. ---- Arizona, U. S. A. Arizona. State Board of Health. Annual report of vital statistics. Phoenix, 1933-34. ---- Biennial report. Phoenix, 1913-14; 1917-18; 1919-20; 1923-32. ---- Bulletin. Phoenix, 1915; 1928. ---- Public health news. Phoenix, No. 1, 1915- ---- Statement of causes of death. Phoenix, 1922-23. Williams, R. C. Pubhc health administration in Arizona. Pub. Health Bull., Wash., 1922, No. 122, 1-49. ---- Arkansas, U. S. A. Arkansas. State Board of Health. Bien- nial report. Little Rock, 1881-82; 1926-28. ---- Asbury Park, New Jersey. Asbury Park, N. J., Board of Health. Annual report. Asbury Park, 1893-94; 1896; 1898; 1910. --- Assam, India. Assam, India. Director of Public Health. Annual sanitary report of the Province. Shillong, 1877-82; 1886- ---- Annual vaccination returns of the Province of Assam. Assam, 1915-22. ---- Supplement of the sanitary report. Assam, 1917; 1919. ---- Triennial vaccination report. Assam, 1917-20. Forysyth, C. E. P. Notes on conditions affecting the health of the European community at Assam. J. Trop. M. Hyg., Lond., 1923, 26: 345.—Public health in Assam for 1921. Lancet, Lond., 1923, 2: 539. --- Athens, Georgia. Athens, Ga. Department of Health of Athens and Clarke County. Annual report. Athens, 1926; 1927; 1937- Auburn, New York. Auburn, N. Y. Department of Health. Annual report. Auburn, 1890-95; 1899-1907; 1909-10. --- Auburn's health. Auburn, 1, 1936- --- Monthly report. Auburn, 1891-97; 1911-35. ---- Augusta, Georgia. Augusta, Ga. Board of Health. Annual reports. Augusta, 1880-88; 1890-1917; 1919-21. ---- Australia [Commonwealth] See also names of Australian States in this list. Australia. Department of Health. Health. Canberra, v.l, 1923- ---- Health organization in Australian ports. 166p. 8? Canberra [1928] ---- Service publication. Canberra, Nos 1-40, 1912-35. Australia. Department of Health. Di- vision of Industrial Hygiene. Service pub- lication. Canberra, Nos 1-9, 1924-29. Australia. Department of Health. School of Public Health and Tropical Medicine. Service publications. Gelbe, N. S. Wales, 1-2, 1934-39. _ ~— Service publications (Tropical division) Melbourne, Nos 1-9, 1924-26. Cumpston, J H. L. Public Health in Australia; the first 42 years. Med. J. Australia, 1931, 1: 491-500. ------ Public health in Australia; the second p.-riod, 1830 to 1850. Ibid., oft ,»m—TTj P,*uJ?J"Lhealth '" Australia; developments £ hi185,?- ■ Ibld-.G79r85:------The evolution of public health administration in Australia. Ibid 1932 1 • 194-8__ Hone, F. S. A ministry of health and a national health service HEALTH ORGANIZATION 163 HEALTH ORGANIZATION Ibid., 1918, 2: 445-9.—Piper, C. T. Public health; health work' in country centres. Ibid., 1939, 2: 244-51.—Report of the Royal Commission on Health. Ibid., 1926, 1: 57-80. ---- Austria. Austria. Bundesministerium fur soziale Verwaltung. Volksgesundheitsamt. Mit- teilungen. Wien, 1919-33. ---- Veroffentlichungen. Wien, 1-20, 1919- 23. Ensthaler, J. Die oberosterreichische Sani- tatsgemeinde. 144p. 8? Linz, 1934. Dietrich, E. Das osterreichische Ministerium fiir Volks- gesundheit. Deut. med. Wschr., 1918, 44: 103.—Gstettner, M. Hygienische Beratungsstellen. Wien. klin. Rdsch., 1919, 33: 52; 64.—Hochenegg, von. Das Ministerium fiir Volksgesund- heit. Wien. med. Wschr., 1918, 68: 1333-47. Also Klin. ther. Wschr., 1918, 25: 233-43.—Schwalbe, J. Der Gesetz- entwurf zur Errichtung des osterreichischen Ministeriums fur Volksgesundheit. Deut. med. Wschr., 1918, 44: 46; 78 — Teleky, L. Das Ministerium fiir Volksgesundheit und das Ministerium fiir soziale Fiirsorge. Wien. klin. Wschr., 1918, 31: 448-50. ---- Bahamas. Bahamas. Colonial Secretary's Office. Annual medical and sanitary report. Nassau, 1918; 1920-21; 1924; 1926- --- Bahia, Brazil. Maciel, H. Condicoes sanitarias, organizacao hospitalar e servicos de Saude Publica no Estado da Bahia. Fol. med., Rio, 1934, 15: 221-6.—Services (Os) de saude publica na Bahia. Brasil med., 1940, 54: 235 bis. --- Baltimore, Maryland. Baltimore, Md. Health Department. Annual report. 1857-60; 1865-66; 1868- ---- Baltimore health news. Bait., 1897- --- Keeping well; the 2. ser. of radio talks broadcast. 284p. 8? Bait., 1937. ---- Monthly morbidity and mortality statistics. Bait., 1925-34. Fitch, G. J. Sanitation and public health. Baltimore Health News, 1930-31, 7:-8: 148-50. ---- Bangkok, Sianv. Bangkok, Siam. Medical Officer of Health. Annual report. Bangkok, 11.-13., 1907-8; 1909-10. --- Bangor, Maine. Bangor, Maine [City Government] Annual report. Bangor, 1905-6- ---- Banjoewangi, East Java. Walch, E. W. [Sanitation in Banjoewangi (East Java)] Meded. dienst volksgez. Ned. Indie, 1933, 22: 16-9. ---- Barbados. Barbados. Chief Medical Officer. Re- port. Barbados, 1928- Barbados. Public Health Inspector. An- nual report. [Bridgetown] 1.-15., 1913-27. ---- Annual report of the poor law inspector Bridgetown] 1925. Barbados. Government. Blue book, 1933- 34. Barbados, 1934. ---- Barcelona, Spain. Pons y Freixa, F. Estado actual de los servicios de sanidad urbana de nuestra ciudad y necesidad inaplacable de su hi- gienizaci6n. Rev. med. Barcelona, 1935, 23: 242-60. ---- Barnsley, England. Barnsley, Eng. Medical Officer of Health. Annual report of county borough of Barnsley. Barnsley, 1865; 1869; 1871-81; 1884; 1916-20; 1922; 1924; 1925; 1927-30. | ---- Barry, Wales. Barry, Wales. Medical Officer of Health Annual report. Barry, 1919-30. --- Basutoland, South Africa. Macfarlane, N. M. A record of medical work and of the medical service in Basutoland. Caledon. M. J., 1934-35, 15: 314; 343; 370. ---- Batavia, Java. Sardjito [Organization of municipal health service in Batavia] Meded. dienst volksgez. Ned. Indie, 1930, 19: 23-41. ---- Bath, England. Bath, Eng. Medical Officer of Health. Annual report. Bath, 19., 1885; 31., 1896; 34., 1899; 36.-48., 1901-13; 50., 1915 [54.] 1919- ---- Bavaria, Germany. Bayern, Germ. Staatsministerium des Innern. Bericht uber das Bayerische Ge- sundheitswesen. Munch., 38.-40., 1908-1913; 53., 1933. ---- Bay City, Michigan. Bay City, Mich. Board of Health. An- nual report. Bay City, 1893-1902. --- Belfast, Ireland. Belfast, Ireland. Officer of Health. Report on the health of the county borough. Belfast, 1894-1904; 1908-1912; 1914-15; 1923; 1925; 1927-29; 1932-34; 1936-37. --- Belgium. Belgium. Conseil Superieur d'Hygiene Publique. Recueil des rapports. Brux., 18., 1910- Belgium. Ministere de l'interieur; Ad- ministration de l'hygiene. Bulletin. Brux., 1922-35. Belgium. Ministere de la sante publique. Bulletin. Brux., 1: 1936- Belgium. Ministere de l'IntIsrieur et de la sante publique. Office central de statistique. Recensement des families; re- censement general de la population au 31 de- cembre 1930. 71p. 32cm. Brux., 1938. --- Tables de mortality de la population Beige 1928-32; recensement general de la popu- lation au 31 decembre 1930. 63p. 32cm. Brux. [1933] Action (L') du Ministere pendant l'exercice 1937-38. Bull. Min. san. pub., Brux., 1938, 3: 97-102.—Commission inter- ministSrielle d'action sanitaire. Ibid., 567.—Commission Royale de la Sant6 Publique. Ibid., 565-7.—Conseil Su- perieur d'Hygiene Publique. Ibid., 556-8.—Groupe d'etude de l'enseignement manager post-scolaire convoqu6 par le Ministre de la sant6 publique. Ibid., 288-94.—Ide, M. Le bilan de l'hygiene officielle. Rev. mid., Louvain, 1927, 284-7.— Laruelle, L. L'administration de l'hygiene 1906-8. Mouve- ment hyg., Brux., 1909, 25: 112-27.—Malvoz. Conseil su- perieur d'hygiene; conclusions du rapport sur les travaux des Commissions medicales en 1910. Ibid., 1912, 28: 12-26. ---- Bell Ville, Cordoba. Arfeli, J. A. Las obras sanitarias de la ciudad de Bell Ville (Provincia de C6rdoba) Bol. obras san. nac, B. Air., 1940, 4: 462-71. ---- Bengal Presidency, India. Bengal, India. Public Health Depart- ment. Annual report. Calc, 31., 1898- ---- Annual report of the Chief Engineer. [20.] Calc, 1932- ---- Annual report of the sanitary board. Calc, 1932- ---- Annual report on sanitation. Calc, 1914-17. HEALTH ORGANIZATION 1(>4 HEALTH ORGANIZATION --- Annual statistical returns and short notes on vaccination. Calc, 1914-IS. Bengal public health report for the year 1938. Ind. M. Gaz., 1941, 76: 376.—Resolution reviewing the reports on the working of municipalities in Bengal during the year 1932-33 (Government of Bengal, local self-government department) pubhc health. Ibid., 1935, 70: 590.—Sarcar, A. K. Pubhc health activities in the Bengal presidency. Ind. M. Rec, 1937, 57: 72-5. --- Berkeley, California. Berkeley, Calif. Health Department. Annual report. Berkeley, 1925-26. --- Berkshire, England. Berkshire, Exc Medical Officer of Health. Annual report. Berkshire, 1.-7., 1873-79; 8.-18., 1881-91; 1894-1908. --- Bermondsey, England. Bermoxdsey, Eng. Medical Officer of Health. Report on the sanitary condition of the borough. [Bermondsey] 1865-73; 1907- --- Bermuda. Bermuda. Medical and Health Depart- ment. Medical report on health and sanitary conditions. Hamilton, 1906-16; 1921- --- Bessarabia. Milovidov, S. I. [State of sanitary and medical service in Bessarabia and Northern Bukovina] Sovet. med., 1940, 4: No. 22, 40-3. --- Bethnal Green, England. Bethxal Greex, Eng. Medical Officer of Health. Report. Bethnal Green, 21.-34., 1875-84; 1917- --- Bhavnagar, India. Bhavnagar State Council. Report on the Administration of the Bhavnagar State for the year 1932-1933. Bhavnagar, 1934. --- Bihar and Orissa, India. Bihar & Orissa, Ixdia. Director of Public Health. Annual report. Patna, 1912- --- Annual sanitary report. Patna, 1915- 17; 1919-20. --- Report on vaccination (annual & trien- nial) Patna, 1911/12-1927/28. Bihar & Orissa, India. Public Health Exgixeering Department. Annual report Patna, 15.-23., 1926/27-1934/35. --- Binghamton, New York. Bixghamtox, N. Y. Department of Health. Annual report. Binghamton, 1898-1915. --- Birkenhead, England. Birkenhead, Exg. Medical Officer of Health. Annual report on the sanitary condi- tions. Birkenhead, 1915-17. --- Birmingham, Alabama. Fox, C. Public health administration City of Birmingham 19^6C3ll"t3291-302erSOn' Akbama- Pub- Health ReP- wash., --- Birmingham, England. Birmingham, Eng. City Analyst. Annual report. Birmingham [1935] 1936. Birmingham, Exg. Medical Officer of Health. Annual report. Birmingham \l 1 1873- --- Blackburn, England. Blackburn, Exg. Medical Officer of Health. Annual report. Blackburn, 1891- 1922; 1926. --- Infectious diseases in Blackburn schools. 168p. 23'jcm. Blackburn, 1904. --- Report upon the sanitary conditions of the public elementary schools of Blackburn. 424p. 24cm. Blackburn, 1904. Blackburn, Eng. School Medical Officer. Annual report. Blackburn, 1904-21. --- Bolivia. Bolivia. Direccion general de sanidad publica. Boletin. La Paz, v.l, No. 1, 1929; v.2, Nos 4-5, 1930. Sanjines, C. Report. Tr. Internat. San. Conf. Am. Repub., 1911, 5. Conf., 81-5. --- Bolton, England. Bolton, Eng. Medical Officer of Health. Annual report. Bolton, l.-ll., 1874-84; 1890; 1910-11;1913;1916-30. --- Bombay City, Bombay. Bombay City. Public Health Depart- ment. Monthly bulletin of health. Bombay, 13: 1929- Annual report of the executive health officer of the city of Bombay for 1938. Ind. M. Gaz., 1940, 75: 253. --- Bombay Presidency, India. Bombay Presidency. Director of Public Health. Annual notes and triennial reports on vaccination. Bombay, 1902/3-1927/28. --- Annual report. Bombay, 35: 1898- Bombay, India. Chemical Analyser to Government. Report (1934) Bombay, 1935. --- Bootle, England. Bootle, Eng. Medical Officer of Health. Annual report. Bootle, 1910- Bootle, Eng. School Medical Officer. Annual report. Bootle, 19J1-32. --- Bosnia, Austria. Oesterreich-Ungarn. Landesregierung fur Bosnien und die Hercegovina. Das Sanitatswesen in Bosnien und der Hercegovina, 1878-1901. 439p. 8? Sarajevo, 1903. --- Boston, Massachusetts. Boston, Mass. Board of Health. Annual report. Bost., 1854-57; 1860-1928; 1931- --- Monthly bulletin. Bost., v.6-21, 1917-32. --- Bouches-du-Rhdne, France. Villeneuve, de. Statistique du departement des Bouches du-Rhone, avec atlas; Marseille, 1824. Observ. sc. med., 1825, 9: 131-43. --- Bournemouth, England. Bournemouth, Eng. Medical Officer of Health. Annual report. Bournemouth, 1892; 1894-95; 1910-14; 1916; 1918- --- Bradford, England. Bradford, Eng. Medical Officer of Health. Annual report. Bradford, 1878; 1880-89; 1893- --- Brazil (Estados Unidos do Brasil) Brazil. Departamento nacional de saude publica. Archivos de hygiene. Rio, v.1-7, 1927-37. HEALTH ORGANIZATION ---- Boletim sanitario. Rio, v. 1-5, 1922-26. Brazil. Directoria geral de saude publica. Annuario de estatistica demographo-sanitaiia. Rio, 1910-14. ---- Boletim hebdomadario de estatistica demographo-sanitaria. Rio, 1897-1934. ---- Boletim mensal de estatistica demo- grapho-sanitaria. Rio, 1903-34. Barros Barreto, J. de. Creacao dum Departamento na- cional de saude no Brasil. Bol. Of. san. panamer., 1937, 16: 611-4.----— Servicos federais de salide no Brasil. Ibid., 1938, 17: 479-94.—D'Amato, H. J. Problemas sanit&rios; conferencia propalada por L. R. A., r&dio del Estado el 16 de mayo de de 1941, por el Secretdrio general del Departamento nacional de Higiene. Rev. brasil. farm., 1941, 22: 407-9.— Departamento nacional de saude. Arq. med. leg. ident., Rio, 1940, No. 18, 159-69, 4 pl.—Federal (The) department of health [Brazil] J. Am. M. Ass., 1941, 117: 132.—Fontenelle, J. P. O trabalho de saude publica no Brasil. Congr. brasil. hyg. (1926) 1927, 3: 3-25. ------ Organizacao do districto federal do Brasil em 1935-36. Bol. Of. san. panamer., 1938, 17: 124-8. ------ O trabalho dos laboratorios da saude publica. Fol. med., Rio, 1938, 19: 214-7. ------ A or- ganizacao distrital na administracao de saude publica. Ibid., 1941, 22: 201-6.—Freeman, A. W. Organizacao e adminis- tracao de Saude Publica. Ibid., 1926, 7: 172-4— Joffily, A. A administracao sanitaria nos Estados e sua organizacao basica. Ibid., 1941, 22: 212-7.—Lima, S. Organizacao sanitaria dos Estados TJnidos do Brasil. Actas Conf. san. panamer., 1934, 9. Conf., 479-84. --- Bridgeport, Connecticut. Bridgeport, Conn. Department of Health. Monthly bulletin. Bridgeport, 1901; 1904-10; 1917-19; 1922-23. --- Brighton, England. Brighton, Eng. Medical Officer of Health. Annual report. Brighton, 14.-18., 1887-91; 1894-1931. --- Brisbane, Queensland. Tilling, H. W. Pubhc health in Greater Brisbane. Med. J. Australia, 1927, 1: 105-8. --- Bristol, England. Bristol, Eng. Department of Public Health. Annual report for city and county. Bristol, 1892; 1894- Bristol Port, Eng. Medical Officer of Health. Annual report. Bristol, 1893; 1897- 1920; 1922-23; 1928-30; 1932- ---- British Columbia, Canada. British Columbia, Can. Board of Health. Bulletin. Victoria, v.6, 1936- British Columbia, Can. Provincial Board of Health. Annual report. Victoria, 13., 1909/10- ——■ Medical inspection of schools. Victoria, 1.-3., 1911-14; 21., 1932- ---- Vital statistics report. Victoria, 56., 1927- Hershey, J. M. The British Columbia Peace River health unit. Canad. Pub. Health J., 1939, 30: 445-50.—Marshall, J. T. The development of pubhc health in British Columbia. Ibid., 1934, 25: 359-68. --- British Guiana. British Guiana. Director of Medical Services. Report. Georgetown, 1940- British Guiana. Government Medical Officer. Report of the Surgeon General. Georgetown, 1903-39. --- British Honduras. British Honduras. Medical Officer. Medical reports. Belize, 1899; 1907- --- British Virgin Islands. British Virgin Islands. Medical Officer. Medical and sanitary report. Antigua, 1935- HEALTH ORGANIZATION --- Brockton, Massachusetts. Brockton, Mass. Health Department. Annual report. Brockton, 1890; 1892- --- Mortality report. Brockton, 1917- --- Brookline, Massachusetts. Brookline, Mass. Board of Health. Annual reports. Brookline, 1876-77; 1892- ---- Health bulletin. Brookline, v.l, 1920- ---- Brunei, Brit. North Borneo. Brunei Province, Borneo. Medical Offi- cer. Annual report. Brunei, 1927- ---- Bruxelles, Belgium. Bruxelles. Direction de l'hygiene pu- blique. Bulletin mensual de statistique. Brux., 53. yr., 1922- ---- Rapport annuel. Brux., 1910-12, 1919-21; 1923- Wilmart, J. Application des mesures d'hygiene par l'Ad- ministration communale de Bruxelles en 1907. Mouvement hyg., Brux., 1908, 24: 209-17. ---- Buenos Aires, Argentina. Buenos Aires, Arg. Minister de Obras publicas. Atlas sanitario. 378p. 27cm. La Plata, 1923. Salubridad (La) y asistencia sanitaria de Buenos Aires. Libro de oro (B. Air. Fac. cienc. m£d.) B. Air., 1941 [61-4]— Tobias, J. W. Contribuci6n al estudio del problema econ6- mico-financiero de la administraci6n sanitaria y asistencia publica de la capital federal. Rev. med., B. Air., 1940, 2: 461-72. --- Buffalo, New York. Buffalo, N. Y. Department of Health. Annual report. Buffalo, 1904-36. ---- Sanitary bulletin. Buffalo, 1908-34. ---- Bulgaria. Bulgaria [State Department of Public Health] Arkhiv na Glavnata direktsia na narodnoto zdravie. Sofia, v.l, 1921-30. ---- Burlington, Vermont. Burlington, Vt. Health Department. Annual report. Burlington, 1878-1911. ---- Report of vital statistics [monthly] Burlington, 1894-1907. ---- Burma, India. Burma, India. Chemical Examiner. Re- port. Rangoon, 1935- Burma, India. Director of Public Health. Annual sanitary report. Rangoon, 1899-1921. ---- Report on the public health administra- tion. Rangoon, 1922- Report on the state of pubhc health in Burma during 1939. Ind. M. Gaz., 1941, 76: 378. --- Butte, Montana. Butte, Mont. Department of Health. Annual report. Butte, 1910-14. ---- Cairo, Egypt. Cairo, Egypt. Department of Public Health. Reports and notes of the Public Health Laboratories. Cairo, Nos 1-7, 1918-30. ---- Report. Cairo, 1915-29. ---- Calcutta, Bengal Presid. Calcutta, Bengal. Health Officer. Ab- stracts of vital statistics. Calcutta, 1922- ---- Report of the health officer. Calcutta, 1877-1927; 1929-31. ---- Reports of the health officer of the ports of Calcutta and Chittagong. Calcutta, 1922- HEALTH ORGANIZATION 166 HEALTH ORGANIZATION --- Calgary, Canada. Calgary, Can. Department of Public Health. Annual report. Calgary, 1916-20; 1933- --- Report of the medical officer. Calgary, 1917- ---- California, U. S. A. Califorxia. State Department of Health. Biennial report. Sacramento, 1870-1896; 1898- ---- Bulletin (monthly) Sacramento, v. 1-17, 1905-22. ---- Quarterly bulletin. Sacramento, v.1-2, 1922-23. ---- Special bulletin. Sacramento, Nos 1-57, 1913-31. ---- Weekly bulletin. Sacramento, v.l, 1922- Cole. t;. L. Some observations noted in the work of the medical advisorv board of the Health Commission. Cali- fornia J. M.. 1919, 17: 169-72.—Dickie, W. M. Pubhc health in California. Week. Bull. California Dep. Pub. Health, 1936, 15: 145-8.—Full-time health units in California, July 1, 1938. Ibid., 1938-39, 17: 97.—Historical notes on public health in California. Ibid., 1937-38, 16: 117. --- Cambridge, England. Cambridge, Exg. Medical Officer of Health. Annual report on the sanitary condi- tion. Cambr., 1894- Cambridge. Exg. Medical Officer of Health. School Medical Officer. Annual report. Cambr., 1910- --- Cambridge, Massachusetts. Cambridge, Mass. Board of Health. Annual report. Cambr., 1878- --- Canada. Canada. Departmext of Pensions and National Health. National health review [Quarterly] Ottawa, v.l, 1933- --- Report. Ottawa, 1894- Bell, W. J. Canadian government agencies for pubhc health administration. Proc. Conf. Health Author. N. America, 1931, 46. Conf., 117-29.—Brandon. K. F. Public health in upper Canada. Canad. Pub. Health J., 1934, 25: 483-7 — Burke. F. S. The medical investigation division. Ibid., 1939, 30: 145-7.—Davison, R. O. PubUc health. Ibid., 1940, 31: 457-00.- Department (A) of Health for Canada. Pub. Health Rep.. Wash., 1919, 34: 1973-6.—Gregoire, J. Address. Canad. Pub. Health .1., 1941, 32: 435-43.—Heagerty, J. J. The development of public health in Canada. Ibid., 1934, 25: 53-9.------Recent developments in public health and medical services in Canada. Proc. Conf. Health Author. N. America, 1935, 50. Conf., 11-25. ■------ The activities of the national health section. Canad. Pub. Health J., 1939, 30: 120-3.—Jackson, F. W. Medical and pubhc health services in Canada; their recent extension and future. Lancet, Lond., 1938. 1: 1459-62— McCullough. J. W. S. What we should spend on public health in Canada. Canad. J. M. & S., 1927, 61 : 149-52.—National Health Section; Department of Pensions and National Health. Canad. Pub. Health J., 1937, 28: 200-2.—Need (The) for Federal Government assistance in pubhc health. Ibid., 1941, 32: 478.—Power, C. G. Progress in pubhc health in Canada. Ibid., 1936, 27: 380-4.— Wayling, T. Guardian of Canada's health. Health, Toronto, 1941, 9: 4; 21; 5 portr.—Wodehouse, R. E. The Department of Pensions and National Health of the Dominion of Canada. Proc. Conf. Health Author. N. America, 1940, 55. meet., 13. --- Canal Zone, U. S. A. Panama Canal, Zone, U. S. A. Health Department. Annual report. Balboa Heights, 1905- ---- Report (quarterly) 1917-18. ---- Report. Mount Hope, 1904- ---- Twenty-five years of American medical activity on the Isthmus of Panama, 1904-29. 74p. v Panama, 1929. Chamberlain, W. P. La sanidad en el Canal de Panama, durante el afio calendario de 1927. Bol. Of. san. panamer., Wash., 1929,8: 1177-M —Curry, D. P. The work of the heal th department of the Panama Canal during the past 5 years. Mil. Surgeon, 1934, 75: 242-8.— Russell. F. F. Summary and discussion of the work performed in the Board of Health laboratory during the calendar year 1916. Proc. M. Ass. Isthmian Canal Zone, 1917, 10: pt 1, 7-27.— Wakcman, B. R. Health administration of the Panama Zone. N. \ ork State J. M., 1930, 30: 274-9. --- Canterbury, England. Canterbury, Eng. Medical Officer of Health and the Sanitary Inspector of the City and County. Annual report. Canter- bury, 25., 1901; 38.-41., 1914 17; 43.-45., 1919-21. --- Canton, Ohio. Canton, Ohio. City Health Department. Annual report. Canton, 1900; 1920. --- Cape Breton Island, Canada. Beckwith, C. J. W. The Cape Breton Island health unit Canad. Pub. Health J., 1939, 30: 343-7. --- Cape Town, Cape. Capetown. Medical Officer of Health. Annual report. Capetown, 1896/97; 1899/1900; 1901/2-1922/23;1924/25- --- Cardiff, England. Cardiff, Eng. Medical Officer of Health. Annual report. Cardiff, 1894-1933. Cardiff, Exo. Medical Officer of Health. School Medical Officer of City and Port. Annual report. Cardiff, 1921-26. --- Cattaraugus County, New York. Cattaraugus County, N. Y. Board of Health. Annual report. Olean, 1., 1923- --- Ceara, Brazil. Ceara, Brazil. Directoria geral de hygiene. Relatorio. Ceara, 1916-24. --- Cetynye, Yugoslavia. Frolich, W. Sozial-hygienische Einrichtungen in Cetinje, Militiirarzt, Wien, 1918, 52: 69-74. --- Ceylon. Ceylon. Director of Medical and Sani- tary Services. Administration report. Colom- bo, 1898- Administration report of the director of medical and sani- tary servic.es, Ceylon, for 1936. Ind. M. Gaz., 1938, 73: 185-7. Also J. Trop. M. Hyg., Lond., 1938, 41: 95. --- Chadderton, England. Chadderton, Eng. Medical Officer of Health. School Medical Officer and Medi- cal Officer to the Chadderton, Royton and Crompton Joint Hospital Board. Report on the health of the district and the sanitary in- spectors report. Chadderton, 1910-35. --- Chambers County, Alabama. Chambers County, Ala. Health Depart- ment. Annual report [Lafayette, 1941—] --- Charleston, South Carolina. Charleston. Ordinances relating to the duties of the members of the board of health, the board of inspection and the city register. 8°. Charleston, 1850. Charleston, S. Car. City Board of Health. Annual year book. Charleston, 1880- 1930; 1932-38. --- Report [annual] Charleston, 1880- 1935. HEALTH ORGANIZATION 167 HEALTH ORGANIZATION --- Charleston, West Virginia. Charleston, W. Va. City Health De- partment. City of Charleston health bulletin. Charleston, 1922. --- Chelsea, Massachusetts. Chelsea, Mass. Board of Health. Annual reports. Chelsea, 1901-6; 1908-24. ---- Cheltenham, Eng. Cheltenham, Eng. Medical Officer of Health. Annual report of the sanitary condi- tions of the borough of Cheltenham. Chelten- ham, 1901-15. ---- Annual report of the Medical Officer of health and of the School Medical Officer. Chel- tenham, 1919-20. --- Chicago, Illinois. Chicago, III. Department of Health. Annual report. Chic, 1833-1930; 1932; 1939- ---- Bulletin. Chic, v.9-10, 1906-7. ---- Bulletin of the Chicago School of Sani- tary Instruction. Chic, n. ser., v. 1-17, 1907-23. ---- Chicago's health. Chic, v.18-25, 1924-31. --- Chicopee, Massachusetts. Chicopee, Mass. Board of Health. Annual report. Chicopee, 1895-1926; 1928- --- Chile. Chile. Direcci6n general de sanidad. Boletin sanitario. Santiago, v.l, 1927. Chile. Direcci6n General de Sanidad. Departamento Central de BioESTADfsTicA. La estadistica sanitaria chilena, 1936. 36p. 8? Santiago de Chile, 1936. Chile. Servicio nacional de salubridad. Boletfn. Santiago, 1934. Cruz Coke, E. Plan de gobierno presentado por el Ministro de Salubridad. Rev. chilena hig., 1937, 1: suppl., 3-11.— Davila Boza, A., Ferrer, P. L., & Cordova, L. Report. Tr. Internat. San. Conf. Am. Repub., 1911, 5. Conf., 91-5.— Guzman, L. La evolution de la sanidad publica en Chile. Reforma med., Lima, 1941, 26: 135-44.—Memoria anual 1937. Rev. chilena hig., 1937, 1: suppl., 3-23. --- China. China. Central Field Health Station. Report. Shanghai, 1., 1931-33. China. National Health Administration and Central Field Health Station. National epidemic prevention bureau; a report. Peiping, 1919-34. --- Chinkiang, China. Balean, H. Customs medical report: health of Chinkiang. China M. J., 1916, 30: 417-20. ---- Chosen. See in this list Tyosen. ---- Cincinnati, Ohio. Cincinnati, Ohio. Department of Health. Annual report. Cincin., 1867-1918. ---- Cincinnati's health. Cincin., v.l, 1938- ---- Cincinnati sanitary bulletin. Cincin., v.1-10, 1919-27. ---- Weekly report. Cincin., 1911-17. ---- Cleveland, Ohio. Cleveland, Ohio. Department of Public Health and Welfare. Annual report. Clevel., 1868-69; 1875; 1877-82; 1884-30. --- Cleveland's annual health review. Clevel., 1933- Emerson, H. Pubhc health service. Cleveland Hosp. & Health Surv., 1920, pt 2, 103-91. ---- Colombia. Colombia. Ministerio de trabajo e higiene. Revista de higiene, Bogota v.13, 1932- ---- Salud y sanidad. Bogota, v.2, 1933- Blanco, E. A. Informe del medico director de la Tercera comisi6n sanitaria departamental, correspondiente a los meses de marzo y abril del corriente afio. Salud & san., BogoU, 1937, 6: No. 57, 9-12.—Diez C, A. El Centro mixto de salud de Bello; una institution modelo; sus primeros meses de funcionamiento. Rev. hig., Bogota, 1940, 21: 23-35.— Ramirez S., J. Un gobernante que comprende la situaci6n; comisiones sanitarias. Salud & san., Bogota., 1937, 6: No. 57, 19-23.—Sandoval, J. Programa para el saneamiento de la regi6n de Casanare. Rev. mid. Bogotd, 1934-35, 44: 881-8. --- Colombo, Ceylon. Colombo, Ceylon. Medical Officer of Health. Report. Colombo, 1907- --- Colorado, U. S. A. Colorado. State Board of Health. An- nual and biennial reports. Denver, 1.—11., 1876-1912; 1921- --- Colorado Springs, Colorado. Colorado Springs, Colo. Department of Public Health and Sanitation. Annual report. Colorado Spr., 1895; 2.-5., 1903-7; 7., 1909- --- Report (monthly) Colorado Spr., 1897- Hiscock, I. V. A survey of public health activities in Colorado Springs and El Paso County, Colorado, including official and volun- tary agencies. 143p. 22}£cm. Colorado Spr., 1937. --- Conco, Italy. [Vicenza, Italy] Regolamento di pubblica igiene der Comune di Conco. 38p. 23>^cm. Bassano, 1871. --- Concord, New Hampshire. Concord, N. Hamp. Health Department. Annual report. Concord, 1875-84; 1887-1918. --- Mortuary report. Concord, 1898-1903; 1905-23; Nos 1-3, 1924; 1925-31; No. 1, 1932; 1933-34. ---- Congo Beige. Dubois, A. L'organisation de l'hygiene au Congo beige. Arch. mid. beiges, 1933, 86: 117-32. ---- Connecticut, U. S. A. Connecticut. State Department of Health. Connecticut health bulletin. Hart- ford, 1898-1902; 1909-12; v.28, 1914- ---- Report. Hartford, v.l, 1878- ---- Weekly health bulletin. Hartford. 1921- ---- Weekly morbidity report. Hartford, 1934. Foote, F. M. What does your health department cost? Connecticut Health Bull., 1938, 52: 123-5. ---- Cork, Ireland. Cork, Ireland. Medical Officer of Health. Annual report. Cork, 1910-17; 1930. ---- Costa Rica. Costa Rica. Subsecretaria de policia, higiene y salud publica. Boletfn. San Jose, v.l, Nos 1-10, 1923. Amador, J. Significaci6n y alcance de las TJnidades Sani- tarias. Rev. med., S. Jose, 1936, 3: 327-39.—Iglesias, F. Report. Tr. Internat. San. Conf. Am. Repub., 1911, 5. Conf., 97-100.—Nunez, S. La sanidad en Costa Rica, Bol. Of. san. 68 HEALTH ORGANIZATION HEALTH ORGANIZATION panamer., Wash., 1929, 8: 11-3. ------ Ramos [et al.] Or- ganizaci6n sanitaria. Actas Conf. panamer. dir. nac. san., 1936, 3. Conf., 76-s_' — Zeledon, J. El nuevo ministro de salubn.la.l publica cir Costa Rica. Rev. med., S. Jose, 1939-40, 4: 179 81. --- Coventry, England. Covextry, Exg. Medical Officer of Health. Annual report. Coventry, 16.-17., 1890-91; 20.-22., 1894-96; 124., 898- --- Cremona, Italy. Grasselli, G. Le vicende sanitarie di Cremona durante il 1903 e la cronaca dei servizi. 64p. 8? Cremona, 1904. ---- Crewe, England. Crewe, Eng. Medical Officer of Health. Annual report. Crewe, 1905-19; 1923-27; 1929-30. --- Croydon, England. Croydon, Eng. Medical Officer of Health. Annual report. Croydon, 11., 1910- --- Cuba. Cuba. Department of sanitation and charities. Report of the work done by the department in favor of the protection of infancy from May 29, 1913 to date. Habana, 1914. Cuba. Secretaria de sanidad y bene- ficiexcia. Boletin semanal epidemiol6gico sani- tario. Habana, No. 1, 1921- --- Sanidad y beneficiencia. Habana, v.l, 1909- Cuba. Servicio tecnico de salubridad. Informes. Habana, v.l, 1938- ---- Curasao, Neth. West Ind. See in this list Netherlands West Indies. ---- Cyprus. Cyprus. Department of Health. Annual medical & sanitary report. Nicosia, 1913- ---- Czechoslovakia. Albert, B. [Report on the repeal of the ministry of public health] Vest. desk, lek., 1926, 38: 751-3— Helbich, K. [Fu- ture of public health ministerium] Ibid., 679.—Ichok, G. L'action sanitaire k l'fetranger; la protection de la sant6 pu- blique enTchGcoslovaquie. Rev. hyg., Par., 1938, 60: 185-96.— Kunc, K. [Discussion in regard to the public health minis- terium] Vest. cesk. lek., 1926, 38: 791.—Plato, F. Gesund- heitsdienst im Protektorat Bohmen und Mahren Med Welt, 1940, 14: 721. ---- Dakar, Senegal. Soul, F. L'ceuvre sanitaire de la circonscription de Nakar et d£pendances pour la protection de la sante publique (1927- 28) Bull. Soc. path, exot., Par., 1929, 22: 368-77. --- Dallas, Texas. Dallas, Texas. Board of Health. Annual report. Dallas, 1900-3; 1905-14; 1921. --- Darlington, England. Darlington, Eng. Medical Officer of Health. Annual report on the health of the county borough. Darlington, 1898; 1911- --- Dayton, Ohio. Dayton, Ohio. Department of Public Welfare. Division of Health. Annual report. Dayton, 1867-1908; 1912; 1918-24 --- Health bulletin. Dayton, 1918-25. --- Delaware, U. S. A. Delaware. State Board of Health. Biennial and annual report. Dover. 1879-84- 1888-98; 1908- --- Delaware health news. Dover, v.1-13, 1924-39. Beckett, R. C. What the public works program has meant to Delaware. Delaware M. J., 1936, 8: 175-7. ---- Delhi (Province) India. Annual public health report of the Delhi Province for the year 1939. Ind. M. Gaz., 1941, 76: 314-8.—Public (The) health of Delhi. Med. Off., Lond., 1935, 53: 61. ---- Denmark. Denmark. Sundhedsstyrelsen. Medicinal- beretning for den Danske Stat. Kbh., 1877- 1908; 1926- [Activity of the State Board of Health for the year 1879] Ny pharm. tid., Kbh., 1881, 13: 288-95—Frandsen, J. [Sani- tary system and organization] Ugeskr. laeger, 1939, 101: 331-9.—Hindhede. M. [Health control] Ibid., 1940, 102: 955.—Kiaer, R. |Annual report of the activity of the hygiene committee for 1939-40] Ibid., 887-9. --- Denver, Colorado. Denver, Colo. Department of Health and Charity. Annual report. Denver, 1895- 98; 1912-14; 1925; 1934- --- Monthly bulletin. Denver, 1890- --- Derbyshire County, England. Derbyshire County, Eng. Medical Offi- cer of Health and School Medical Officer. Annual report. Derby, 1910-11; 1913-16; 1918- --- Detroit, Michigan. Detroit, Mich. Board of Health. Annual report. Detr., 1881-1907; 1909-16. --- City health. Detr., 1893-97; 1916- ---- Weekly health review. Detr., 1. ser., 1920-25; 1I.-12. ser., 1930-31. Bureau of sanitary engineering. City Health, Detr., 1938, 22: 26. ---- District of Columbia, U. S. A. See in this list Washington, D. C. ---- Dominican Republic. Dominican Republic. Secretaria de estado de sanidad y beneficencia. Informe anual. Santo Domingo, 1919-20; 1922- Hayden, R. Review of the reorganization of the sanitary and public health work in the Dominican Republic under the United States Military Government of Santo Domingo. U. S. Nav. M. Bull., 1922, 16: 657-71.—Jackson, T. W. Public health in the Dominican Republic. Am. J. Trop. M., 1921. 1: 331-49.—Labrador, J. B. Inauguration de obras sanitarias en la Republica Dominicana. Bol. Of. san. pan- amer.. Wash., 1936, 15: 1033.—Martinez Boog, M. Organiza- tion sanitaria en la Republica Dominicana. Ibid., 1933, 12: 1-7. ---- Douala, French Cameroon. Robin. La reorganisation du service d'hygiene k Douala, Cameroun. Ann. hyg., Par., 1940, n. ser., 18: 166-96. --- Dover, New Hampshire. Dover, N. Hamp. Board of Health. An- nual report. Dover, 1879; 1900; 1911; 1913-15; 1921-24. ---- Dresden, Germany. Miiller. Die gesundheitlichen Aufgaben des Dresdner Wohlfahrtspolizeiamtes. Bl. Volksgesundh., 1927, 27: 109-111. --- Duluth, Minnesota. Duluth, Minn. Health Department. An- nual report. Duluth, 1896-97; 1906-10; 1911-12; 1926- --- Monthly report. Duluth, 1898-1900; 1904-5; 1911. --- Dundee, Scotland. Dundee, Scot. Public Health Depart- ment. Annual report. Dundee, 1907-9; 1922- HEALTH ORGANIZATION 169 HEALTH ORGANIZATION ---- Dunkirk, New York. Toomey, A. D. The Dunkirk health center. Month. Bull. N. York State Dep. Health, 1919, n. ser., 14: 144. --- Durban, Natal. Durban, Natal. Medical Officer of Health. Report. Durban, 1912-17; 1921-22; 1924-28. --- Durham, England. Durham, Eng. Medical Officer of Health. Annual report. Durham, 1920- --- Durham, North Carolina. Durham and County, N. Carolina. De- partment of Health. Annual report. Dur- ham, 1919; 1922-24. --- Monthly bulletin. Durham, v.2, No. 1-2, 1926. --- Dutchess County, New York. Weber, J. J. Filling in the gap; details of a comprehensive plan to better health conditions in Dutchess County, New York. Trained Nurse, 1916, 56: 1-5. --- Easington, England. Easington. Medical Officer. Report. Wingate, 1893-98. Johnstone, R. W. Report to the Local Government Board on the sanitary circum- stances and administration of the Rural District of Easington. 17p. 8? Lond., 1909. --- East Orange, New Jersey. East Orange, N. J. Board of Health. Annual report. E. Orange, 1916- --- Ecuador. Ecuador. Director General de Sanidad. Informe que el senor director general de sanidad presenta ante el senor Ministro del ramo, 1910, 1913-22, 1938-39. Guayaquil, 1910-39. Cornejo y Gomez. E. F. Report. Tr. Internat. San. Conf. Am. Repub., 1911, 5. Conf., 107-9.—Kendall, A. I. National and international relations of sanitation in Ecuador. Tr. Chicago Path. Soc, 1919, 9-14.—Suarez, P. A. Organizacion sanitaria del Ecuador. Bol. Of. san. panamer., Wash., 1927, 6: 109-19, portr. --- Edinburgh, Scotland. Edinburgh, Scot. Medical Officer of Health. Annual report. Edinb., 1905- ---- Weekly health report. Edinb., 1916-17. --- Egypt. Egypt. Ministry of Public Health. An- nual report. Cairo, 1910- ---- Annual report on the anti-malaria work. Cairo, 1., 1919- ---- Annual report of the public health laboratories. Cairo, 1918- ---- Report of the medical officer. Cairo, 1915-29. Egypt. Ministry of Public Health. En- demic Diseases Section. Annual report. Cairo, v.9, 1936- Annual report on the work of the department of public health for 1931. J. Trop. M. Hyg., Lond., 1934, 37: (suppl.) 65—8.—Expose sommaire des travaux accomplis par l'ad- ministration de l'hygiene publique depuis 1923 jusqu'& ce jour. Rev. prat. mal. pays chauds, 1929, 9: 547-56.—Furno, A. I progressi della igiene pubblica in Egitto. Riforma med., 1933, 49: 1947-9.—Ministry (The) of public health, Egvpt (1936) J. Trop. M. Hyg., Lond., 1940, 43: 114-6.—Outstand- ing features of public health work in Egypt. Ibid., 1938, 41: 28-31.—Public health in Egypt; annual report for 1920. Lancet, Lond., 1923, 1: 881.—Public health progress in Egypt during 1936. J. Trop. M. Hyg., Lond., 1939, 42: 283-6 — Sebai Bey, D. M. History of the evolution of the Dep. of Public Health of Egypt. J. Egypt. M. Ass., 1928,11: 357-67 — Tedeschi, C. L'organizzazione sanitaria dell'Egitto. Osp. maggiore, Milano, 1929, 17: Suppl., 47-50. --- Elizabeth, New Jersey. Elizabeth, N. J. Board of Health. Sani- tary code. Elizabeth, 1913. --- El Paso, Texas. El Paso, Tex. Department of Health. Monthly bulletin. El Paso, 1915-18; 1924-27. Rocha, I. da, & Ferrari, A. Report. Tr. Internat. San. Conf. Am. Repub., 1911, 5. Conf., 87-9.—Sand, R. How public health is organized in Brazil. Bull. League Red Cross Soc, 1935, 16:3. ---- England. See in this list Great Britain. ---- Erie, Pennsylvania. Erie, Pa. Board of Health. Annual re- port. Erie, 1897-1921. ---- Essex County, New Jersey. Essex County, N. J. Chief Medical Examiner. Annual report [1926-] [Newark, 1927-] --- Estonia. Malton, J. Ueber die Sanitatsorganisation in Estland. Acta Soc. med. Duodecim, 1939, 27: ser. B. No. 4, 1-11.— Rammul, A. On the state of the Public Health in Estonia. Fol. neuropath, eston., 1925, 3:-4: 430-32. --- Exeter, England. Exeter, Eng. Medical Officer of Health (City and County) Annual report of vital statistics, sanitary work [&c] Exeter, 1894- 1937. Exeter, Eng. School Medical Officer of Health. Annual report. Exeter, 1928-37. --- Falkirk, Scotland. Falkirk, Scot. Medical Officer of Health. Report (annual) Falkirk, 1910-28; 1933- --- Fall River, Massachusetts. Fall River, Mass. Board of Health. Annual report. Fall River, 1887-1929. --- Monthly bulletin. Fall River, 1918-30. --- Federated Malay States. See in this list Malay States. ---- Fiji. Fiji. Medical Department. Annual report. Suva, 1898-1933; 1935- Lambert, S. M. Extract from annual report on Western Pacific health service for year 1938. Native M. Pract., Suva, 1940, 3: 469-72.—Some aspects of the public health work in Fiji and the Western Pacific Islands for 1937, and the progress accomplished by the Central Medical School, Suva, during the year. J. Trop. M. Hyg., Lond., 1939, 42: 334-9. ---- Finland. Finland. Laakintohallitus. Kertomus. Hels., 1873- --- Fitchburg, Massachusetts. Fitchburg, Mass. Board of Health. Annual report Fitchburg, 1891-1913; 1916-19. --- Flint, Michigan. DeKleine, W. The Health Department at Flint, Michigan. Nation's Health, Chic, 1921, 3: 276-9. ---- Florida, U. S. A. Florida. State Board of Health. Annual report. Jacksonville, 1890-95; 1899- HEALTH ORGANIZATION 1 70 HEALTH ORGANIZATION ---- Florida health notes (monthly) Jackson- ville, v. 1-5, 1892-99; n. ser., v.l, 1906- Florida. State Board of Health. Cen- tral Bureau of Vital Statistics. Statistics of mortality, birth, stillbirth, infant mortality, marriage [&c] Jacksonville, 1937- Porter, J. Y. Additional scraps from memory's storehouse of sanitary deeds in Florida during the past half century. J. Florida M. Ass., 1926-27, 13: 33-46. ---- Fonzaso, Italy. Facen, J. Fonzaso e il suo distretto; cenni statistici. 67p. 17cm. Trento, 1869. ---- Forth Worth, Texas. Fort Worth, Tex. Department of Public Health and Welfare. Annual summary. Fort Worth, 1924; 1925; 1930. --- Framingham, Massachusetts. Armstrong, D. B., & Stone, A. K. Health equipment.in Framingham; then and now. Nation's Health, 1923, 5: 125-7. --- France. France. Department de l'interieur. Bu- reau de l'Hygiene Publique. Recueil des travaux du Comite consultatif d'hygiene pu- blique de France et des actes officiels de l'ad- ministration sanitaire. Par., 1872-78; 1881- 1902; 1905; 1907-9; 1924. France. Ministere de l'hygiene. Di- rection DE L'ASSISTANCE ET DE L'HYGIENE publique. Statistique sanitaire. Par., 1887- France. Ministere de la sante publique. Bulletin. Par., v.l, 1936- Ingrand, H. *Le Comit6 de Salubrity de 1'Assembled Nationale Constituante (1790-91) 172p. s? Par., 1934. Martial, R. La charte francaise d'hygiene; documents pour servir a son histoire et k son achevement. 9Gp. 8? Par., 1925. Boyd, G. Le ministere de la santd publique: ce qu'il est; ce qu'il devrait dtre. Ann. hyg., Par., 1934, n. ser., 12: 41-60. ------ Corporation «1 * - In santd publique. J. mid. Paris, 1940, 60: 355-60.— Cazeneuve. P. Sur la composition du conseil supdrieur d'hygiene publique dc France et des conseils d'hygiene ddparumentaux k l'occasion de la revision de la loi ■ lu 15 fevnei 1902. Ann. hyg., Par., 1934, n. ser.. 12: 119-27.— Coordination of public health institutions in Fiance. J. Am. M. As-.. 1937, 108: suppl., 72.—Dequidt. Les deleguds sanitaires du decret du 14 aout 1914 et lTn^pection ddparte- mentale d'hygiene. Rev. prat. hyg. mun., Par., 1916, 12: 146-54.—Descroix, L. Quelques reflexions sur le nouveau reglement sanitaire ddpartemental. Techn. san. mun., Par., 1937, 32: 129.—Descroix, P. La statistique au service de 'hygiene. Ibid., 1940, 35: 9.—[France] Loi portant organisa- tion des services de controle et des services extdrieurs du Secretariat d'Etat k l'interieur. Secretariat gdndral k familie et k la santd. Concours med., 1940, 62: 980-2. ------ Loi rdpartissant le territoire national en 20 regions sanitaires, 19 septembre 1940. J. med. Paris, 1940, 60: 348 —Grenoilleau, G. Deux realisations dans le cadre d'une inspection ddparte- mentale d'hygiene. Ann. hyg., Par., 1938, n. ser., 16: 406-27.— Hazemann, K. H. Inventaires et bilans sanitaires. Rev. hyg. mid. social., Par., 1939, 18: 79-87.—Hygiene (L') k la chambre des Reprdsentants; discussion du budget de l'in- terieur. Mouvement hyg., Brux., 1909, 25: 226-34— Ichok, G. Le budget du Ministere de la santd publique et de l'education physique pour 1937. Rev. hyg. med. prev., 1937, 59: 288- 306.—Jacquot, G. E. L'inspection d'hygiene dans le Bassin de Briey. Rev. med. est, 1920, 48: 573-81.—Lessa, A. O armamento sanitario da Franca; notas duma viagem de estudo. Med. contemp., Lisb., 1938, 56: 127-36.—Mery, M. A propos de la suppression dventuelle du ministere de l'hygiene. Ann. hyg., Par., 1922, 4. ser., 38: 336. ------ Rapport presents au nom de la commission d'hygiene sur la proposition de Hayem: k propos de la suppression dventuelle du Ministere de l'hygiene. Bull. Acad, med., Par., 1922, 3. ser., 87: 214-6.— Meyer, L. La suppression du Ministere de l'Hygiene. Mid. scol., Par., 1924, 13: 169-71.—Moine, M. La sante publique en France depuis 1913. Presse med., 1940, 48: 835.—Paquet. L'utilitd d'une statistique sanitaire pdriodique qui serait adressee k tous les prdfets, inspecteurs ddpartementaux d'hv- gidne ou deleguds ddpartementaux (Ddcret du 14 aoiit, 1914J et directeurs de bureaux municipaux d'hygidne. Rev. hyg Par., 1919, 41: 1209-11.—Pohien, K. Die Ausgaben im Haushaltsplan des franzosischen Gesundheitsministenuins fur das Jahr 1934. Reichsgesundhbl., 1934, 9: 826.- Regulations for organization of public health service [France] .1. Am. M. Ass., 1937, 108: 2052.- S.. I. I.. 1 n nouvenu poste sanitaire. Gaz. hop., 1938, 111: 658.- Santcnac. V igncrot-Uode Jet al] L'dquipemcnt sanitaire de la liance. .). mid. 1'aiis. 193S, .r>K: 943-5.—Sayour, A. La carte de l'assainisseiiunt de la liance. Techn. san. mun., Par., 1939, 34: 9-1L- Souza Ferreira. J. A. de. Alguns aspectos da eyolin,;io e dos progresses do Servitu- de saude francos na guerra de 1914-18. Rev. med. mil., Rio, 1940, 29: 479-509.—Sue, G. A. T. .Mdmoire au Roi en son conseil des Ministres et aux cliambres, ou protestation contre le travail de la commission sanitaire centrale du royaurne, institute k l'effet d'examiner les dispositions legislatives et administratives qu'il serait utile d'adopter, pour organiser le service sanitaire des cotes et frontidres de la France, par M. Jean Deveze; Paris, 1820. Observ. provenc. sc. mid., 1821, 2: 150-7. ---- France, colonial. Abbatucci, S. Les services d'hygiene publique dans les colonies francaises. Rev. hyg., Par., 1927, 49: 581; 672 — Achard, C. Mission en Afrique Occidentale Francaise. Bull. Acad, mid., Par., 1936, 3. ser., 116: 580-98, map.—Beaudi- ment, R. Un institut d'hygiene dans une grande ville coloniale. Grand, enddm. trop., 1937, 9: 71-87—Boyc, G. La formation des auxiliaires mddicaux dans les colonies francaises. Bull. Off. internat. hyg. pub., Par., 1935, 27: 315-20—Defoug, G. Les services d'assistance et d'hygiene en A. O. F. Gaz. mdd, France, 1938, 45: 337.— Discours prononee par M. Marina Moutet, Minister des Colonies ;\ l'Academie de Mddecine. Bull. Acad, mdd., Par., 1936, 3. ser., 116: 599-601.—Lasnet. Quelques considdrations sur les conditions de rdussite du programme de protection sanitaire aux colonies. Ibid., 1937, 3. ser., 118: 23-7.—Rapport du mddecin colonel Des Cilleuls; Sdcrdtaire gdndral de la Socidtd. Bull. Soc. mdd. mil. fr., 1938, 32: 3-7. --- Galveston, Texas. Galveston, Tex. Department of Health. Annual report. Galveston, 1896; 1914; 1925- ---- Monthly bulletin. Galveston, 1913-19; 1921-28. ---- Geneve, Switzerland. Thomas, E. Note sur l'existence des officiers de santd dans la Rdpublique et canton de Geneve. Rev. mdd. Suisse rom., 1941, 61: 300-6. --- Georgia, U. S. A. Georgia. Board of Health of the State. Constitution and rules; law creating the board. 14p. 24? Atlanta, 1875. Georgia. Department of Public Health. Annual [and biennial] report. Atlanta, 1.-2., 1874-76; 1907; 1918- ---- Georgia's health. Atlanta, v. 14, 1934- Abercrombie, T. F. Health tendencies in Georgia in the last decade (1922-32) J. M. Ass. Georgia, 1933, 22: 69. ---- Germany. Mobius, E. Aufgabcnkreis und Organisation des staatlichen Gesundheitsamtes. 52p. 8? Lpz., 1936. Veroffentlichungen aus dem Gebiete der Medizinalverwaltung. Berl., v.14, 1921- Veroffentlichungen aus dem Gebiete des Volksgesundheitsdienstes. Berl., v.47, 1936- Adam. Gesundheitsministerium in Reich und Staat. Zschr. arztl. Fortbild., 1919, 16: 322-7.—Gebiihreneinnahmen der Gesundheitsamter. Reichsgesundhbl., 1936, 11: 139 — Gebiihrenerhebung der Gesundheitsamter. Ibid., 1935, 10: 330-3.—[Germany] Deuxidme ordonnance (22 fdvrier 1935) du Ministre de l'lntdrieur du Reich pour l'application de la Loi portant unification des services d'hygidne publique. Bull. Off. internat. hyg. pub. Par., 1935, 27: 1691-7. ----- Runderlass des Reichsministers des Innern iiber Portckosten bei Anfragen der Gesundheitsamter an Aerzte der freien Praxis. Reichsgesundhbl., 1938, 13: 933. ----- Gesetz uber den Aufbau der Verwaltung in der Ostmark (Ostmarkgesetz) vom 14. April 1939. Ibid., 1939, 14: 401-3.—Griesbach, R. Raumeinteilung fiir Tuberkulose-Fiirsorgestellen und Ge- sundheitsamter. Oeff. Gesundhdienst, 1938.-39, 4: B, 92 — Heilig, G. Die Durchfiihrung der Aufgaben der Gesundheits- amter im Kriege. Ibid., 1941-42, 7: A, 78-83.—Krahn. Das Gesundheitsamt und seine Bedeutung fur Volk und Staat. Ibid., 1936-37, 2: A, 450-62.—LaulT. Das Ministerium fur Volkswohlfahrt. Zschr. Fleisch Milchhyg., 1919-20, 30:33.— Leonhard, F. Die Abgrenzung der Zustandigkeit zwischen dem Reich und Bundesstaaten betr. Gesetzgebung und Verwaltung HEALTH ORGANIZATION 171 HEALTH ORGANIZATION des Gesundheitswesens. Berl. klin. Wschr., 1919, 56: 440 — Ministerium (Das) fiir Volksgesundheit. Amtsarzt, 1918, 10: 177-85 —Ministerium (Ein) fur Volksgesundheit und soziale Fursorge. Ibid., 1917, 9: 113-5.—Fohlen, K. Sechzig Jahre Reichsgesundheitsamt; sechzig Jahre Entwicklung deutscher Gesundheitsstatistik. Oeff. Gesundhdienst, 1936-37, 2: B, 245-53.—Spaet. Die Errichtung eines Reichs-Gesundheits- Ministeriums. Miinch. med. Wschr., 1917, 64: 1332-4.— Tugendreich, G. Die Entwicklung des deutschen Gesund- heitswesens. Fortsch. Gesundhfiirs., 1931, 5: 170-5.—Weber, F A Zwei Jahshunderte Sachsisches Medizinalwesen. Veroff. Volksgesundhdienst,. 1937, 48: 515-701.—Zerbe, G. Das Kas- senwesen der staatlichen Gesundheitsamter. Oeff. Gesundh- dienst, 1938-39, 4: A, 132-9. --- Germany, colonial. Week, W. Die Organisation des Gesundheitsdienstes der deutschen Kolonie Ostafrika. Deut. t'ropenmed. Zschr., 1941, 45: 33-43. --- Gibraltar. Gibraltar. Medical Officer of Health. Annual report. Gibraltar, 1891- --- Gilbert and Ellice Islands Colony. Gilbert and Ellice Islands Colony. Med- ical Officer. Medical and sanitary reports. Suva, Fiji, 1913-17; 1922/23- --- Gillingham, England. Gillingham, Exg. Medical Officer of Health. Annual report. Gillingham, 1916; 1922- --- Glasgow, Scotland. Glasgow, Scot. Medical Officer of Health. Report. Glasg., 1899-1904; 1908- Report of the Medical officer of health of the city of Glasgow for 1938. Glasgow M. J., 1940, 133: 119-32. --- Gloucester, England. Gloucester, Eng. Medical Officer of Health. Annual report. Gloucester, 1878-79; 1910- --- Gloucestershire County, England. Gloucestershire, Eng. County Medical Officer of Health. Annual report. Glou- cester, 1878-79; 1908- --- Goteborg, Sweden. Goteborg, Sweden. Halsovardsnamnd. Arsberattelse. Goteborg, 1910- --- Grand Rapids, Michigan. Grand Rapids, Mich. Board of Health. Department of Public Welfare. Annual report. Grand Rapids, 1894-1904; 1906-7; 1910-12. ---- Monthly bulletin. Grand Rapids, 1910- ---- Statements of mortality. Grand Rapids, 1884-1907. --- Graubiinden, Switzerland. Hemmi, J. *Beitrag zur Geschichte des Sanitatswesens in Graubiinden bis zum Anschluss an die Schweiz mit besonderer Berucksichtigung der Stadt Chur [Basel] 135p. 8? Chur, 1914. --- Great Britain. Bannington, B. G. English public health administration. 2. ed. 325p. 8? Lond., 1929. Great Britain. Bureau of Hygiene and Tropical Diseases. Bulletin of hygiene. Lond., v.l, 1926- ---- Tropical diseases bulletin. Lond., v.l, 1912-35; 1940- ---- Tropical veterinary bulletin. Lond., v.1-18, 1912-30. ---- Veterinary bulletin. Lond., v.l, 1931- Great Britain. Local Government Board. Reports on public health and medical subjects. Lond., n. ser., 1-124, 1909-19. Great Britain. Ministry of Health. Annual report. Lond., v.l, 1919/20- --- Reports on public health and medical subjects. Lond., v.l, 1920- B., P. H. A national public health department in England. Am. J. Pub. Health, 1918, 8: 162.—Boulnois, H. P. Fifty years of sanitation in England. Tr. Internat. Conf. San. Engin., 1924, 1. Congr., 17-20.—Censorship of health reports. Med. Off., Lond., 1936, 56: 61.—Collins, W. J. Sanitary progress during the 50 years 1876-1926; public administration. J. R. San. Inst., 1926-27, 47: 84-8.—Dain, H. G. Some statistical comparisons. Brit. M. J., 1933, 1: 186.—Fremantle, F. E. Local administration of the work of the ministry of health. J. State M., Lond., 1919, 27: 268-70.—Gibbon, I. G. Sanitary administration in England and Wales. Tr. Internat. Conf. San. Engin., 1924, 1. Congr., 5-16.—James, A. H. A public health department almanac. Med. Off., Lond., 1921, 26: 253.—McMaster, A. B. Some public health problems in Port Sanitarv Administration. J. R. San. Inst., Lond., 1926- 27, 47: 601-9.—McNalty. A. The public health in 1936. J. R. Inst. Pub. Health, 1937-38, 1: 195-8.—Ministry (A) of Health. Brit. M. J., 1917, 1: 653. Also Med. Press & Circ, Lond., 1918, n. ser., 106: 384-7.—Ministry (The) of health; consultative councils. Lancet, Lond., 1919, 2:622.—Newman, G. The Royal sanitary commission of 1869. In his Building Nat. Health, Lond., 1939, 148-53.—Newsholme, A. El Departa- mento de sanidad en el campo de la medicina, desde el punto de vista de lo observado en Inglaterra. Bol. Of. san. panamer., Wash., 1939, 18: 1048-53.—Public (The) health [London] J. Am. M. Ass., 1936, 107: 801.—Royal sanitary institute congress; the mosaic of the public health service. Brit. M. J., 1939, 2: Suppl., 160.—Smith, W. The work of the ministry of health. J. State M., Lond., 1919, 27: 262-7.—State of the public health. Brit. M. J., 1934, 2: 598.—Weatherly, L. W. Ministry of Health Bill; clause 10. Med. Press, & Circ, Lond., 1920, n. ser., 110: 462.—Wood, F. T. H. The public health service in war-time. Med. Off., Lond., 1940, 64: 77. ---- Greece. White, P. D. Public health in Eastern Macedonia. Am. J. Pub. Health, 1920, 10: 14-21. --- Greenbay, Wisconsin. Greenbay, Wis. Board of Health. Annual report. Greenbay, 1894-1901. --- Greenock, Scotland. Greenock, Scot. Medical Officer of Health. Annual report. Greenock, 1910- --- Grenada, Brit. West Indies. Grenada. Colonial Secretary. Annual medical and sanitary report. St George, 1907- ---r Blue book. St George, 1919- Grenada, Brit. W. Indies. Medical and sanitary department. Report and general abstracts of births, deaths, and marriages, 1907- --- Guatemala. Guatemala. Direccion general de salu- bridad. Boletin sanitario. Guatemala, v.l, 1931- Ortega, S., & Bianchi, J. Report. Tr. Internat. San. Conf. Am. Repub., 1911, 5. Conf., 113-5.—Padilla y Padilla, C. Organizaci6n y actividades de la salubridad publica de Guate- mala. Actas Conf. Panamer. Dir. nac. san., 1931, 2. Conf., 230-3. --- Habana, Cuba. Habana, Cuba. Departamento de sanidad. Secretar!a de gobernaci6n. Manual de practica sanitaria. Habana, 1905. --- Hackney, England. Hackney, Eng. Medical Officer of Health. Report. Hackney, 1856-90; 1893- --- Haiti. [Haiti] Service d'hygiene et d'assistance PUBLIQUE, MEDICAL ET SANITAIRE. Bulletin. Port au Prince, v.6, 1939- HEALTH ORGANIZATION 172 HEALTH ORGANIZATION ---- Rapport annuel. Port-au-Prince, 1926- ---- La legislation de l'hygiene, de l'assistance publique, de l'enseignement et de l'exercice de la m6decine. Fasc. 1-4 (1804-1917) 4v. Port au Prince [1936] Hamet. L'oeuvre sanitaire des Etats-I nis en Haiti. Arch. mdd. pharm. nav., Par., 1929, 119: 66, 1 map, 207 — Rey. S. Le service d'inspection sanitaire k Port-au-Prince. Bull. Serv. hyg., Port-au-Prince, 1939, 6: No. 20, 30-4. ---- Harrisburg, Pennsylvania. HARRISBURG, Pa. BUREAU OF HEALTH AND Sanitation. Annual report. Harrisb., 1892; 1894; 1912-15; 1924-28. ---- Health bulletin. Harrisb., v.l, Nos 1-9, 1915. ---- Hartford, Connecticut. Hartford, Conn. Board of Health. An- nual reports. Hartford, 1.-50., 1885-1935; 1938-39. ---- Health bulletin. Hartford, v.l, 1936- ---- Haverhill, Massachusetts. Haverhill, Mass. Board of Health. Annual report. Haverhill, 2., 1881- --- Hawaii, U. S. A. Hawaii. Board of Health. Annual report. Honolulu, 1876-1930; 1933- --- Herault, France. Scherb, R. L'organisation des Services ddpartementaux d'hvgidne dans l'Hdrault. Ann. hyg., Par., 1936, n. ser., 14: 661-93. --- Holyoke, Massachusetts. Holyoke, Mass. Board of Health. An- nual report. Holyoke [14.] 1893-94- --- Honduras. Zepeda, R. B. Proyecto de una organizaci6n sanitaria practicable en Honduras. Bol. Of. san. panamer., Wash., 1935, 14: 213-22. --- Hong Kong. Hong Kong. Medical Department. Medi- cal and Sanitary Service. Medical and sanitary report. Hong Kong, 1898- Hong Kong. Public Health and Build- ings Ordinance Commission. Report. Hong Kong, 1907. --- Hornell, New York. Hornell, X. Y. Department of Health. Annual report. Hornell, 1913-14. --- Hot Springs, Arkansas. Hot Springs, Ark. Health Department. Annual report. Hot Springs, 1887-93. --- Monthly report. Hot Springs, 1892- 1925. --- Houston, Texas. Houston, Tex. Health Department. An- nual report of vital statistics. Houston (1931-32) 1932-33. ---- Report of vital statistics (monthly) Houston (1931-32) 1932-33. ---- Hudson County, New Jersey. Hudson County, X. J. Board of Health and Vital Statistics. Annual report. Jersey City, 1877-87; 1900- --- Health record. Jersey City, 1., 1934- ---- Monthly report of vital statistics. Jer- sey City, 1888-1933. ---- Hungary. Xepegeszsegugy. Budap . v. 18, 1937- Bevere, L. I recenti sviluppi delloiganizza/.ione igienico- ^anitaria dellTngheria. Ann. igiene, 1937, 47: 597-625.— Grosz. E. [National Public Health Council] Orvoskdpzds, 1937, 27: 252-7.— Heinrich, E. [Organization of public health service) Orv. hetil., 1938, 82: 138.—[Hungary] [Order No. 90-1940. B. M. for determinating district headquarters of the Hungarian public health Officers] Ndpegdszsdgiigy, 1940, 21: 173-8.—[Inaugural session of the National Health Council of Hungary] Orv. hetil., 1937, 81: 139-42—Johan, B. [Ge- sundheitspolitik in der ungarischen Hygienetatigkeit] Orsz. Kozegdszs. Int. kozl., 1934, 7: No. 11.---— L'oeuvre de l'hvgidne publique prdventive en Hongrie. Presse mdd., 1938, 46: 1007. ------ [Organized public health work] Ndpegdszsdgiigy, 1941, 22: 490-6.—Melly, J. Le ddveloppe- ment de l'hygiene en Hongrie. Rev. hyg. mdd. prdv., 1937, 59: 193-202.—INew organization of the Public health Division of the Hungarian Department of the Interior] Ndpegdszsdgiigy, 1940, 21: 181-5.—Scholtz. K. [Public health in Hungary] Orv. hetil., 1933, 77: 957-75. ------ [Public health in Hungary after the Trianon treaty] Ndpegdszsdgiigy, 1941, 22: 870-89.—Szel, T. Hygidne publique. Magy. statiszt. szemle 1938, 16: 391-400, map. --- Hyderabad, India. Hyderabad, India. Medical and Sani- tary Departments. Administration report. Hyderabad, 1905-26. Hyderabad, India. Sanitary commissioner. Annual report. Hyderabad, 1873- --- Idaho, U. S. A. Idaho. Department of Public Welfare. Biennial report. Boise, Idaho, 1919- Idaho. State Board of Health. Biennial reports [Boise] 1908-14. ---- Illinois, XL S. A. Illinois. Department of Public Health. Annual report. Springf., 1878-97; 1903-8; 1913; 1917- ---- Educational health circular. Springf., Xo. 3- ■--- Illinois health messenger. Springf., v.l, 1929- —-— Illinois health news Springf., v.1-14, quarterly. Springf., Springf., v.2, 1906; Nos 194-6; 1915-28. ---- Illinois health v.1-5, 1929-33. ---- Monthly bulletin v. 4-8, 1908-12. ---- Radio talks. Springf., 198; 200; 202, 1933-34. Illinois. State Board of Health. Report of the sanitary investigations of the Illinois River and its tributaries; with special reference to the effect of the sewage of Chicago on the Des Plaines and Illinois Rivers prior to and after the opening of the Chicago Drainage Canal. 219p. 8? Chic, 1901. ---- Report of sanitary investigations of the Illinois, Mississippi and Missouri Rivers; with relation to the effect of the sewage of the city of Chicago, and the sanitary conditions of the water supplies of the cities of Chicago and St Louis. 23p. 8? Chicago, 1904. Applewhite, C. C. Administrative features of public health in Illinois. Illinois Health Mess., 1939, 11: 34-6.—Baxter, A. C. Department of pubhc health; State of Illinois. Bull. Chicago M. Soc, 1940-41, 43: 164. ■------ The organization and function of the district health units of the State depart- ment of public health. Illinois M. J., 1941, 79: 217-21 — Classen, C. W. Development of the division of sanitary engineering of the State department of public health. Ibid., 1940, 77: 431-3—Drake, C. S. C. The Department of Public Health. Illinois Health News, 1919, 5: 5-10.—Grubbs, S. B. PubUc health administration in Illinois. Pub. Health Rep., Wash., 1915, 30: 1479-545.—How the State Department of Health functions. Illinois Health News, 1923, 9: 5-16.— Illinois is healthiest large State. Ibid., 195.—Leonard, T. H. The service offered by the State Department of Public Health to the people of the State of Illinois. Inst. Quart., Springf., 1922, 13: Nos 3 & 4, 196-208 —Ruediger, G. F. Cooperation HEALTH ORGANIZATION 173 HEALTH ORGANIZATION in public health administration at Lasalle, Peru und Oglesby, Illinois. Am. J. Pub. Health, 1915, 5: 1226-9.—Thome, C. H. The Illinois Department of Public Welfare. Inst. Quart., Springf., 1918, 9: 20-3. --- India. Great Britain. Secretary of State for India. Reports on sanitary measures in India. Lond., 1867-1912. India. Public Health Commissioner (after 1919 called Sanitary Commissioner) Annual report, Calc. & Delhi, 1864- India. Sanitary Commissioner. Scientific memoirs by the officers of the medical and sanitary departments of the government. Calc, pt 1-12, 1884-1901; n. ser., No. 1-60, 1902-13. Turner, J. A., & Goldsmith, B. K. Sanita- tion in India. 3. ed. xiv, 1133p. 8? Bombay, 1922. Graham, J. D. The public health of India. Science, 1935, 81: 145.—Health (The) services of India. Med. Off., Lond., 1940, 64: 137.—Jenks, H. N. Public health work in India; a review of the nature and progress of sanitation. Am. J. Pub. Health, 1919, 9: 943-51—Raja, K. C. K. E. A plea for a forward public-health policy in India. Ind. M. Gaz., 1937, 72: 428-36—Russell, A. J. H. Population and public health in India. Tr. Far. East. Ass. Trop. M. (1927) 1928, 1: 613-40. -----Le Conseil central consultatif d'hygidne de l'lnde. Bull. Off. internat. hyg. pub., Par., 1938, 30: 527-35.—Ukil, A. C. Public health in modern states and its application in India. Calcutta M. J., 1941, 38: 95-7. --- India: Central Provinces and Berar. Central Provinces and Berar, India. Public Health Department. Annual report. Nagpur, v.l, 1868- Annual report of the Pubhc Health Department in the Central Provinces and Berar for the year 1939. Ind. M. Gaz., 1941, 76: 377. --- India: North-West Frontier Province. India. North-West Frontier Province. Chemical Examiner. Report. Allahabad [etc.] (1902) 1903- Lndia. North-West Frontier Province. Director of Public Health. Notes on vac- cination. Calcutta, (1922/23-1927/28) 1923-28. ---- Report on vaccination and public health. Peshawar (1905/6)-1906- --- Indiana, U. S. A. Indiana, U. S. A. Division of Public Health. Annual report. Indianap., 1., 1882- 1924; 1926-27. ---- Monthly bulletin. Indianap., v.l, 1899- Quarterly bulletin. Indianap, v.3, 1899. Crowder, J. H. Some observations on the plan for the establishment of district health units by the State Board of Health. J. Indiana M. Ass., 1939, 32: 193-5.—Ferree, J. W. Indiana's pioneer venture in full-time district health depart- ments. Month. Bull. Indiana Div. Pub. Health, 1937, 40: 109.—Hurty, J. N. Review of public health work in Indiana. J. Indiana M. Ass., 1918, 11: 181-7.—King, W. F. The next important step in administrative public health in Indiana. Ibid., 1930, 23: 411-3.—Reorganization of the Indiana State Board of Health. Ibid., 1933, 26: 209-12— Stemm, W. H. Public health work by the Indiana State Medical Association. Ibid., 1919, 12: 257-60. ---- Indo-China. Huot. Rapport sur le fonctionnement des services sani- taires et mddicaux de l'lndochine pendant l'annde 1920. Ann. mdd. pharm. col., Par., 1922, 20: 74-87—Vassal, J. J. Nhatrang. Ann. hyg. mdd. col., Par., 1906, 9: 481-511. ---- international. See also League of Nations; Panamerican Sanitary Bureau, etc. New York, N. Y. Rockfeller Foundation International Health Division. Annual report. N. Y., v.l, 1913- Paris, France. Office international d'hy- giene publique. Bulletin mensuel. Par., v.10, 1918; v.13, 1921- Vraoz Alfaro, G. La ultima reuni6n del Comitd Interna- cional de Paris. Sem. mdd., B. Air., 1934, 41: pt 1, 566-9 — Bericht iiber die im Oktober 1935 abgehaltene offentliche lagung des standigen Ausschusses des Internationalen Ge- sundheitsamtes zu Paris. Reichsgesundhbl., 1936, 11: 71-5.— Boudreau, F. G. International cooperation in hygiene. Am. J. Pub. Health, 1937, 27: 1102-7.—Breger, J. Die Tagung des Internationalen Gesundheitsamtes in Paris, Mai 1935. Deut med. Wschr., 1935, 61: 2016-9. ------ Die Bedeutung des Internationalen Gesundheitsamtes zu Paris. Reichsgesundhbl., 1935, 10: 4-8.------Die neueren Arbeiten des Internationa- len Gesundheitsamtes. Deut. med. Wschr., 1936, 62: 1345-9; 1938, 64: 344-6.—Buchanan, G. S. International cooperation in public health: its achievements and prospects. Lancet, Lond., 1934, 1: 879; 935; 992.—Comite permanent de l'Office international d'hygidne publique. Gaz. hop., 1935, 108: 946-9._ Also Union mdd. nord-est, 1938, 61: 113; 129; 145.— Comite permanent de l'Office international d'hygidne publique; session extraordinaire de mai 1937. Bull. Off. internat. hyg. pub., Par., 1937, 29: 1075-104.—Dupuy, A. Avons-nous besoin d'attachds sanitaires k l'dtranger? Rev. hyg. mdd. social., 1938, 17: 183-90.—Fit/Gerald, J. G. International public health. Stud. Connaught Lab., 1931-32, 5: No. 7.— Herbstlagung 1937. Reichsgesundhbl., 1937, 12: 858.— International co-operation on health questions. Brit. M. J., 1934, 2: 30.—Internationales Gesundheitsamt zu Paris; Bericht. Reichsgesundhbl., 1936, 11: 806; 918; 1937, 12: 34.— International hygiene. Brit. M. J., 1937, 2: 673.—Jitta, N. M. J. (Concise report of the spring session of the Office of the International Public Hygiene in Paris and of the Committee for hygiene at the Geneva Conference) Ned. tschr. geneesk. 1934, 78: 4115-27.------[Brief report of the meeting of the Office International d'Hygidne Publique; October 8-15, 1934] Ibid., 1935, 79: 344-52. ------ [Brief summary of the pro- ceedings of the spring meeting of the International Office of Pubhc Hygiene in Paris, April 29-May 9, 1935] Ibid., 4072-81. —---- [Brief report of the fall meeting of the Office Interna- tional d'Hvgidne Publique held in Paris October 19-28, 1936] Ibid., 1937, 81: 700-9.------[Brief report of the annual meeting of the Office International d'Hygidne Publique and Assemblde d'Hygidne] Ibid., 4091-8.------[Brief report of the spring meeting of the Office International d'Hygidne Publique, April 24-May 2, 1939] Ibid., 1939, 83: 4246-52.— Lyon, R. A. The development of international health organiza- tions. Ann. M. Hist., 1939, 3. ser., 1: 519-24.—Morgan, M. T. Paris: Office international d'hygiene publique. Bull. Hyg., Lond., 1937, 12: 675-81.—Office international d'hygidne publique; summary of proceedings at the May, 1938, session of the Permanent committee. Ibid., 1938, 13: 685-92.— Office international d'hygidne publique; summary of pro- ceedings at the April-May 1939 session of the permanent committee. Ibid., 1939, 14: 655-63.—Pierret, R. Pubhc health questions in France: international cooperation. Am. Med. J., Par., 1930, 1: 26-30.—Rapport du Ddpartement Suisse de l'intdrieur sur sa gestion de 1921 (Service fdddral de l'hy- giene publique) Bull. Off. internat. hyg. pub., Par., 1922, 14: 1058-76.—Spranger, H. Die Oktobertagung, 1935 des inter- nationalen Gesundheitsamtes. Oeff. Gesundhdienst, 1936- 37, 2: A, 54-9.—Standiger Ausschuss des Internationalen Gesundheitsamts zu Paris; Bericht. Reichsgesundhbl., 1934, 9: 749; 1935, 10: 210; 684. --- Iowa, U. S. A. Iowa. State Department of Health. Annual [and biennial] report. Des Moines, 1., 1881- ---- Iowa public health bulletin. Des Moines, v.l, 1887- ----• Weekly health message. Des Moines, No. 123, 1929- ---- Iran. Cohen, M. M. Considerations sur la defense sanitaire de la Perse. 116p. 8? Par., 1912. Neligan. La santd publique en Perse (1923-1924) Rev. hyg., Par., 1927, 49: 109-20. ---- Iraq. Patchedji, H. *L'6tat actuel de l'hygiene publique en Iraq. 63p. 8? Par., 1928. ---- Ireland. Great Britain. Lord Lieutenant and Privy Council of Ireland. Annual report of the local government board for Ireland. Dubl., 1883-84; 1886-87; 1890; 1901-2. HEALTH ORGANIZATION 174 HEALTH ORGANIZATION Ireland. Department of Local Govern- ment and Public Health. Annual report of the Registrar-General. Dubl., 1., 1922- --- Report. Dubl., 1915; 1922- Hennessy, T. Ireland and a Ministrv of Health. Tr. R. Acad. M. Ireiand (1919) 1920, 37: 456-71.—Hindhede, M. Irish living conditions and their influence on the health of the people] Ugeskr. laeger, 1927, 89: 1079-84.—Ireland and the Ministry of Health Bill. Lancet, Lond., 1919, 1: 5S2.— Irish (The) Public Health Council; memorandum on the hospital >y>tem of Ireland. Dublin J. M. Sc, 1920, 149: 90-4.— Kidd, L. A Ministry of Health for Northern Ireland. Ulster M. J., 1938, 7: 229-40.—McSweeney. C. J. A public health programme for Eire. Irish J. M. Sc, 1940, 6. ser., No. 170, 49-58.—Moloney. M. F. Ireland's national health; an analysis of cases oe,■lining in a southern seaboard district and its lessons. Dublin J. M. Sc, 1918. 145: 17-20.—Moore, J. W. Existing hindrances to pubhc health work in Ireland. Ibid., 1921, 4. ser., 56-63.—Stephenson, E. F. Public health organisation in the Irish Free State. J. State M., Lond., 1930, 38: 574-82. ---- Islington, England. Islington, Em;. Medical Officer of Health. Annual report of the health and sanitary conditions of the metropolitan borough. Islington, 58., 1913- ---- Istanbul, Turkey. Clemow, F. G. The Constantinople Board of Health. Lancet, Lond., 1923, 1: 1074; 1126; 1180. ---- Italy. Abba, F. II risorgimento sanitario italiano. 48p. 8? Biella, 1910. Italy. Direzione generale della sanita pubblica. Notiziario dell'amministrazione sani- taria del regno No. 1: Movimento demografico ed andamento delle malattie infettive e sociali in Italia. 247p. 24cm. Roma, 1938. Sevehag, H. *L'hygiene en Italie; legisla- tion sanitaire; enscignement et organisation. 86p. 8? Lyon, 1903. Ubertis, F. La tutela della salute pubblica e un diritto del popolo ed un dovere delle classe dirigenti. 20p. 12? Acqui, 1905. Abba, F. Vantaggi economici dell'attuale organizzazione sanitaria statale. Difesa sociale, 1930. 9: 44-50.— Bussi, A. La politica sanitaria comunale e l'u.s.-iMenza sociale. Italia san., 1910, 6: 312; 336.—Castiglioni. A. Public health in Italy. Brit. M. .1., 1924, 2: 310, 1925. !: 855.—Consiglio (II) superiore di sanita; la relazione dell C'liiiin. Lutrario. Italia san., 1919, 1: 1-3.—De Blasi. P. L'iiiM'gnamento, la propa- ganda e le opere d'igiene nell'Italia fascista. Ibid., 1932, 24: No. 23-24, 3-8.—Gasperini, C. G. Linee generali dell'igiene e dell'organizzazione igienica nelle isole italiane dell'Egeo. Gior. clin. med., 1930, 11: 411-22— IIvento, A. La nuova organizzazione sanitaria italiana. Difesa sociale, 1924, 3: 169-71.—Labus, G. L'autonomia dell'ispettorato delle con- dotte dall'Ufficio d'igiene. Italia san., 1910, 6: 41-3.—Lu- trario, A. La sanita pubblica in Italia e dell'estero. Med. sociale", Xap., 1922, 12: 21; 37. ------ Extrait du rapport de la Direction gdndrale de la santd publique d'ltalie sur l'activitd des services pendant l'annde 1929. Bull. Off. in- ternat. hyg. pub., Par., 1930, 22: 1744-57.— Sollazzo, G. La corporazione sanitaria. Boll. chim. farm., Milano, 1934, 73: 59-63.—Vittorie i Le) del regime nei campo dell'igiene esaltate nell'Aeeadeinia delle Scienze Mediche di Palermo. Riv. med. social, tuberc, 1936, 13: 74-9.—Weiss, E. II personale di vigilanza igienica ancora in attiviti nelle nuove provincie e le sue attribuzioni. Boll. Ass. med. trident., 1921, 36: 161; 195; 205. ---- Italy, colonial. Denes, G., & Denes, R. Controllo sanitario di operai reduci dallA. O. I. attraverso ! opera dei Laboratori provinciali di igiene e profila-^i. Atti Congr. naz. microb., 1937, 6. Congr., 804-7.—Franchini, G. Le colonie italiane dell'Africa Orientale dal punto di vista sanitario ed igienico. Arch. ital. sc. med. col., 1935, 16: 1S5-506.------Condizioni igienico-sanitarii delle nostre colonie dell'A. O. Riforma med., 1935, 51: 1436- 10.— Ilvento. A. I servizi igienici e medici nelle colonie italiane dell Alii, a Orientale. Gior. med. mil., 1936, 84: 298-305.— I.ucrezi. (.. Organizzazione sanitaria nellAfrica Orientale Italiana. Riforma med., 1910, 56: 123-5.—Morgan. M. T. Italy -Royal decree of the 20. March, 1933. for the organiza- tion of the health services in the colonies. Bull. Hyg., Lond., 1934, 9: 161-5.— Statistiche sanitarie riguardanti Ci'renaica' Somalia italiana; Eritrea G923- 1927; Arch. ital. sc. med' col., 1928, 9: No. 12, p. i rix. --- Jackson, Michigan. Jackson, Mich. Depaktment of Health. Annual report. Jackson, 1915-17. --- Jacksonville, Florida. Jacksonville, Fla. Board of Health. Annual report. Jacksonville, 1879; 1910-17. --- Jamaica. Jamaica. Central Board of Health. Bureau of Health Education. Jamaica public health [monthly] Kingston, 1926- Washburn, B. E. Jamaica health stories and plays. HOp. 8? Kingston, 1929. Annual report of the Superintending Medical Officer for the year ended December 31, 1920. J. Trop. M. Hvg., Lond., 1923, 26: Colonial Med. Rep., No. 150, 31.—Co-operative public health work in Jamaica during 1932. Jamaica Pub. Health, 1933, 8: 9—Creswell, L. O. Public health administra- tion in Jamaica. Med. Off., Lond., 1918, 20: 214 — Report of the co-operative public health work during 1933. Jamaica Pub. Health, 1934, 9: 17-32. ---- Japan. Japan. Sanitary Bureau. Annual report. Tokyo, 1875-1929; 1931-32. ---- Das offentliche Gesundheitswesen in Japan. 40p. 8? Tokio, 1911. ■---- The present state of the medical ad- ministration of the Japanese Empire. 71p. 8? Tokyo, 1914. ---- The sanitary administration of Japan. 43p. 8? [Tokio] 1911. ---- The sanitary laws of Japan. 196p. 8? Tokio, 1911. League of Nations. Health Organisa- tion. Health organisation in Japan. 280p. 4? Geneve, 1925. Mori, R. Japan und seine Gesundheitspflege. 417p. 4? Tokyo, 1911. Como ha organizado el Japon el ministerio de. sanidad. Reforma med., Lima, 1938, 24: 973.—Hundreds of new health centers [Japan! J- Am. M. Ass., 1937, 109: 887.—Jourdran. L'hygidne au Japon. Ann. mdd. pharm. col., Par., 1928, 26: 5-41.—Mackie, F. P. The interchange of health personnel in Japan under the auspices of the League of Nations. Ind. M. Gaz., 1927, 62: 158-64.—Miyairi. K. Public health in- vestigation in Japan. China M. J., 1918, 32: 561.—Tsurumi, M. Creation de centres d'hygiene au Japon. Bull. Off. internat. hyg. pub., Par., 1937, 29: 1203-5.------El Taii o Poteneial biologico japonds y la creacion de centros de higiene en el Japon. Reforma med., Lima, 1937, 23: 745-7.----- Politique nationale de l'hvgiene au Japon. Bull. Off. internat. hyg. pub., Par., 1938, 30: 1963-7. ---- Jefferson County, Kentucky. Trawick, J. D. Plans and policies of the Jefferson County Health Department. Kentucky M. J., 1934, 32: 431. --- Johannesburg, Transvaal. Johannesburg. Central Minixg-Rand Mines Group. Health Department. Re- port. Johannesburg (1934) 1935- JOHANNESBURG. MEDICAL OFFICER OF Health. Report. Johannesburg, 1902- --- Johnstown, Pennsylvania. Johnstown, Pa. Board of Health. Annual report. Johnstown, 1., 1890; 1892-94; 1896- 1916; 1925. --- Monthly statement of mortality. Johns- town, 1917-25; 1927-28. --- Kansas, U. S. A. Kansas. State Board of Health. Biennial report. Topeka, 1., 1885- --- Bulletin. Topeka, v.2-19, 1906-23. — Bulletin (quarterly) Topeka, v. 1-8, HEALTH ORGANIZATION 175 HEALTH ORGANIZATION ---- Kedah, Malaya. Kedah & Perlis. Medical and Health Department. Report. Alor Star, 1925- ---- Keighley, England. Keighley, Eng. Medical Officer of Health. Annual report. Keighley, 1882; 1915- ---- Kent County, England. Kent County, Eng. Medical Officer of Health. Annual report. Maidstone [3.] 1910- --- Kentucky, U. S. A. Kentucky. State Board of Health. Bi- ennial report. Louisville, 1878-83; 1892-93; 1896-1913; 1919. --- Bulletin. Bowling Green, v.l, 1911- McCormack, A. T. Present and future of public health work in Kentucky. Am. J. Pub. Health, 1919, 9: 776-8. ----- Plans and policies of the State Department of Health. Kentucky M. J., 1934, 32: 427-9. --- Kenya Colony and Protectorate, Brit. East Africa. Kenya. Medical Department. Annual report. Nairobi, 1912-37. --- Khartoum, Anglo-Egypt. Sudan. Khartoum, Khartoum North and Omdur- man. Medical Officer of Health. Report on health and sanitation. Khartoum, 1919/20- 1925. --- Kherson, U. S. S. R. Uvarov, M. S. [Public medicine in the county of Yelisavet- grad, government of Kherson] Obsh. san. obozr., S. Peterb., 1896, 1:9. --- Knoxville, Tennessee. Knoxville, Tenn. Board of Health. Annual report. Knoxville, 1874-77; 1881-94; 1896; 1907-10; 1926- --- Official report. Knoxville, 1899-1904. Mountin, J. W. Pubhc health progress in Knoxville, Tenn. Pub. Health Rep., Wash., 1931, 46: 1150-92. --- K0benhavn, Denmark. K0BENHAVN, DENMARK. STADSLAEGE. AarS- beretning angaaende sundhedstilstanden i K0- benhavn. Kbh., 1884- Hansen. S. [Medical report of Kopenhagen for 1933] Aarsber. stadslaege, Kbh., 1933, 5-29. ------■ [Report of the activities in 1933 of the Kopenhagen veterinary and sani- tary comission] Ibid., 37-50. --- Krugersdorp, Transvaal. Krugersdorp. Medical Officer of Health. Health report. Krugersdorp, 1917-23. --- Labrador. See in this list Newfoundland and Labrador. --- Lancashire County, England. Lancashire County, Eng. Medical Officer of Health. Annual report to the education committee. Preston, 1., 1909- --- Report. Preston, 1889- ---- Lancaster, Pennsylvania. Lancaster, Pa. Board of Health. Annual report. Lancaster, 1896-1917. ---- Latvia. Roesle, E. Die Gesundheitsstatistik Lettlands (Latvija) Deut. med. Wschr., 1925, 51: 748-50. ---- League of Nations. See League of Nations. ---- Leeds, England. Leeds, Eng. Medical Officer of Health Annual report. Leeds, 1876- --- Le Havre, France. Le Havre, France. Bureau municipal d'hygiene. Rapport. Le Havre, 1910- ---- Leith, Scotland. Leith, Scot. Public Health Department. Annual report. Leith, 1.-4., 1901-4; 6.-14.. 1906-14. ---- Leningrad, U. S. S. R. Frenkel, Z. G. [Social health and problems of sanitation of Leningrad during the second five-year plan] Tr. Vtor. Leningr. med. inst., 1935, No. 6, 136-43. ---- Lexden & Winstree Rural District, Eng- land. Lexden & Winstree Rural District Coun- cil. Medical Officer of Health. Annual report. Colchester, 1891-1903. ---- Liberia. Liberia. Medical Specialist. Report on the medical survey of Liberia (2., Grand Cape Mount County) 12p. 4? Monrovia, 1936. ---- Lima, Peru. Alemnara, G. Reforma de los servicios municipales de higiene y salubridad de Lima. Cron. mdd., Lima, 1932, 49: 229-36. ---- Lincoln, Nebraska. Lincoln, Neb. Department of Health. Annual report. Lincoln, 1928-29; 1931-32; 1934-35. —— Bulletin (monthly) Lincoln, 1921- ---- Lithuania. [Lithuanian Health Convention] Third convention, Oct. 2-4, 1924] 245p. 8? Kaunas, 1926. Ozelis, K. [Work for improvement of health in Lithuania] Medicina, Kaunas, 1939, 20: 438-57.—Sidlauskas, A. [Or- ganization of sanitation in Lithuania] Ibid., 1927, 8: 673-88. ---- Liverpool, England. Liverpool, Eng. Medical Officer of Health. Report of the health. Liverp., 1845-47; 1858-82; 1884- ■----Annual report. Liverp., 1910-12; 1914-17; 1922- ---- London, England. London, Eng. Medical Officer of Health. Annual report. Lond., 1850-55; 1857-73; 1894- ---- Los Angeles, California. Los Angeles, Calif. Department of Health Commissioners. Annual reports. Los Ang., 1888-91; 1904-5; 1911-25; 1928-29; 1931- ---Monthly health reports. Los Ang., 1894-1925. ---- Los Angeles County, California. Los Angeles County, Calif. Department of Health. Annual report. Los Ang., 1930-33. --- Bulletins. Los Ang., 1915. ---- Louisiana, U. S. A. ' Louisiana. State Board of Health. Bi- ennial report. N. Orleans, 1884-1933. ---- Lauderdale County, Mississippi. Health department dedicated (Lauderdale County) Missis- sippi Doctor, 1939-40, 17: 342-6. HEALTH ORGANIZATION 176 HEALTH ORGANIZATION ----The history and work. 80p. S? New Orleans, 1904. ---- Monthly bulletin. N. Orleans, 1896-97; 1912-2S. --- Quarterly bulletin. N. Orleans, v.3, 1912- ---- The sanitary code, 1899. 406p. 8? New Orleans, 1K*»9. Dowling, O. Advances in public health work in Louisiana during the past year. South. M. J., 1917, 10: 552-4.—Morris, A. What Louisiana is doing. Am. J. Pub. Health, 1919, 9: 780-2.—Sharp, W. K., jr. Modern trends in pubhc health work in Louisiana. N. Orleans M. & S. J., 1937, 90: 8-13. --- Louisville, Kentucky. Louisville, Ky. City Health Depart- ment. Annual report. Louisville, 1897-1915; 1919-21; 1938- --- Lowell, Massachusetts. Lowell, Mass. Board of Health. Annual report. Lowell, 1846-81; 1887-1927. --- Lynchburg, Virginia. Rosenthal, S. H. Public health work in Lynchburg. Vir- ginia M. Month., 1921-22, 48: 504-7. --- Lynn, Massachusetts. Lynx, Mass. Board of Health. Annual report. Lynn, 1849; 1880-1917; 1927-34. --- Mortuary reports (monthly) Lynn, 1898- --- McKeesport, Pennsylvania. McKeesport, Pa. Board of Health. An- nual report. McKeesport, 1895-1916. --- Madison, Wisconsin. Madison, Wis. Health Department. An- nual report. Madison, 1890-91; 1885; 1887-88; 1895-96; 1898-1900; 1902-3; 1912-17. --- Bulletin. Madison, v.l, 1904- --- Madison County, Alabama. Madison County, Ala. Health Depart- ment. Annual report. Huntsville, 1921-23. --- Madras, India. Madras, India. Health Department. Monthly bulletin of health. Madras, v. 1-11, 1924-34. Report of the Director of Pubhc Health, Madras, for the year 1939. Ind. M. Gaz., 1941, 76: 379. ---- Madrid, Spain. Pons Freixa, F. Lo que es y lo que deberfa ser la higiene publica en nuestro pais; estado actual de los servicios de sanidad urbana en nuestra ciudad y necesidad inaplazable de su higienizaci6n. Med. ibera, 1935, 29: pt 1, 262. ---- Madura, Madras. Rajagopalan. N. Pubhc health in Madura city. Med Off., Lond., 1941, 65: 71. --- Maine, U. S. A. Maine. Department of Health and Wel- fare. Division of vital statistics. Annual report of births, marriages, divorces and deaths. Augusta, v.l, 1892- Maine. State Department of Health. Annual report. Augusta, v.l, 1885-1919. --- Bulletin. Augusta, 1905-20; Nos. 1-5, n. ser., 1922. Bristol. L. D. Pubhc health accomplishments and needs in Maine. Bull. State Dep. Health Maine, 1920, 3: 355-74 Also J. Maine M. Ass., 1920-21, 11: 243-59. --- Malay States (Federated) Federated Malay States. Medical De- partment. Annual report. Kuala Lumpur 1910-16; 1919-35. P ' --- Maiden, Massachusetts. Malden, Mass. Boakd of Health. Annual report. Maiden, 10.-[41.] 1893-1924. --- Monthly bulletin on mortuary and sanitary conditions. Maiden, 1912-20. --- Malta. Malta. Public Health Office [Medical and Health Department] Annual report. Malta, 1895- --- Manchester, England. Manchester, Eng. Medical Officer of Health. Annual report. Manchester, 1868-83; 1891- Harris, H. Manchester board of health in 1796. Ieis, Bruges, 1938, 28: No. 76, 26-37. --- Manchester, New Hampshire. Manchester, N. Hamp. Health Depart- ment. Annual report. Manchester, 1890- ---- Quarterly health bulletin. Manchester, 1918-24. ---- Manchester, Virginia. Manchester, Va. Board of Health. An- nual report. Manchester, 1905-8. ---- Manila, Philippine Islands. Corpus, T. Certain adjustments in health work in the city of Manila are required to attain maximum efficiency. J. Philippine Islands M. Ass., 1933, 13: 198-203. --- Manitoba, Canada. Manitoba, Canada. Department of Health and Public Welfare. Annual report. Winnipeg, 1929-30; 1933-36. — Report. Winnipeg, 1., 1928- Mitchell, R. The development of public health in Manitoba. Canad. Pub. Health J., 1935, 26: 62-9. ---- Marianao, Cuba. Nogueira, P. Unidad sanitaria de Marianao. San. & benef., Habana, 1940, 43: 5-37. ---- Marioupol, U. S. S. R. Nikolaev, J. [Health preservation in Marioupol] Profil. med., Kharkov, 1927, 6: No. 12, 142-5. --- Marlborough, Massachusetts. Marlborough, Mass. Board of Health. Annual report. Marlborough, 1895-1916. --- Martinique. Lamoureux, A. L'hygiene k la Martinique en 1921. Bull. Soc. path, exot., Par., 1922, 15: 179-88.—Lapeyre, J. L. L'organisation sanitaire k la Martinique. Presse med., 1936, 44: 1461-3. --- Maryland, U. S. A. Maryland. State Board of Health. An- nual report. Bait., 1874- --- Monthly bulletin. Bait., v.l, 1929- Maryland State Planning Commission. Public health administration in Maryland. 153p. 29 x 2ZY2cm. Bait., 1938. Fulton, J. S. Recent advances in the State Department of Health of Maryland. Maryland M. J., 1915, 58: 250-6. --- Massachusetts, U. S. A. Massachusetts. Department of Public Health. Annual report. Bost., 1., 1870- --- Commonhealth. Bost., v.5, 1918- --- Monthly health bulletin. Bost., v. 1-9, 1906-14. Public health bulletin. Bost., v. 1-5, 1914-18. Massachusetts. State Board of Health. A brief history of its organization and its work 1869-1912. 70p. 8? Bost., 1912. HEALTH ORGANIZATION 177 HEALTH ORGANIZATION Massachusetts health journal [quarterly] Bost., 20., 1934- Richardson, W. L. Summary of seven years' work of the State Board of Health of Massa- chusetts. 61p. 8? Bost., 1876. Whipple, G. C. State sanitation; a review of the work of the Massachusetts State Board of health. 2v. 8? Cambr., 1917. Chadwick, H. D. Digest of the twentieth annual report of the Massachusetts Department of Pubhc Health. N. England J. M., 1935, 212: 830-6.—History of the State Board of Health to 1914 and the State Department of Health to 1919. Common- health, Bost., 1919, 6: 271-94, 2 pl.—Kiernan, F. Massa- chusetts State Health Commission. N. England J. M., 1935, 213: 921-4.—MacDonald, E. J. New activities of the Divi- sion of Adult Hygiene. Commonhealth, Bost., 1938, 25: No. 1, 4-7.—Royer, B. F. Work at the Massachusetts-Halifax Health Commission. Am. J. Pub. Health, 1922, 12: 195-201. Also Med. J. Australia, 1922, 1: 451-6.—Sedgwick, W. T. What Massachusetts has done and may yet do for the pubhc health. Am. J. Pub. Health, 1915, 5: 637-41. --- Massillon, Ohio. Massillon, Ohio. Board of Health. An- nual report. Massillon, 1904-20. --- Mauritius. Mauritius. Medical and Health Depart- ment. Annual report. Port Louis, 1898- Progress (The) accomplished in the Medical and Health Department of the colony of Mauritius during 1936. J. Trop. M. Hyg., Lond., 1938, 41: 189-93. --- Medford, Massachusetts. Medford, Mass. Board of Health. An- nual report. Medford, 1895-1902; 1904-7; 1909-15; 1921; 1923; 1925. --- Melbourne, Victoria. Melbourne. Health committee. Report. Melb., 1916- Hepburn, E. A. Engineering branch, Public Health De- partment: its origin, development and duties. Health Bull., Melb., 1935, 1257-64. --- Melrose, Massachusetts. Melrose, Mass. Board of Health. An- nual report. Melrose, 1892-98; 1901-29. --- Memphis, Tennessee. Memphis, Tenn. Board of Health. An- nual report. Memphis, 1879-1918. --- Monthly health bulletin. Memphis, v.l, 1936- --- Monthly mortality report. Memphis, 1917-20. ---■ Official report [monthly] Memphis, 1895; 1897-98; 1900; 1902. Preble, P. A review of public health administration in Memphis, Tennessee based upon a survey of health activities and sanitary conditions in May 1920, and recommendations for reorganization of the health department. Pub. Health Bull., Wash., 1921, No. 113, 1-116. --- Mercer County, West Virginia. Lepper, D. B. Mercer county health activities. West Virginia M. J., 1934, 30: 225-8. ---- Merida, Yucatan. Esquivel Fernandez, J. M. Esbozo de acci6n sanitaria en la ciudad de Merida. Rev. med. Yucatdn, 1936-37, 19: 79-87. ---- Mexico. Mexico. Departamento de Salubridad Publica. American friends service committee. 4p. 27y2cm. Mex., 1940. ---- Boletfn. Mex., D. F., v.1-3, 1921-23; 1925-29. ---- Disposiciones generales relativas a las Brigadas sanitarias m6viles. lOp. 4? M6x., 1936. „ ' Health Department's schedule of work for 1940. 6p. 27Hcm. Mex., D. F., 1940. ----Memoria de los trabajos. Mex., D. F.. 1925-28. ' ' — Organizacion y funcionamiento de los Servicios sanitarios en los Estados y Territorios. 24p. 4? Mex., D. F., 1936. ---- Plan sexenal de 1940 a 1946. 9p. 27/2cm. Meoc., D. F., 1940. ----Salubridad. Mex., D. F., v.1-4, 1930- 33. Pani, A. J. Hygiene in Mexico; a study of sanitary and educational problems; transl. by E. L. de Gorgoza. 218p. 8? N. Y., 1917. Siurob, J. Tendencias modernas de la salu- bridad en la Republica Mexicana. 48p. 8? Mex., D. F., 1936. Bustamante, M. E. Local public health work in Mexico. Am. J. Pub. Health, 1931, 21: 725-36.—Campo Posada. A. Informe sobre las organizaciones sanitarias de la repflbhca de Mejico. Rev. big., Bogota, 1937, 18: No. 6, 5-29, 4 ch.— Esquivel Medina, H. Travaux realises par le dfipartement de l'hygiene publique au Mexique par application des prescrip- tions du plan sexennal. Bull. Off. internat. hyg. pub., Par., 1939, 31: 300-4.—Malda, G. M. El Departamento de Salu- bridad de Mexico. Rev. mid. veracruz., 1923, 3: 321-6.— Monjaras, J. Report. Tr. Internat. San. Conf. Am. Repub., 1911, 5. Conf., 117.—Sanidad-(La) en Mexico. Bol. Of. san. panamer., Wash., 1934, 13: 201-9; 1937, 16: 212.—Villanueva, A. Los problemas fundamentales en Mexico en materia de salubridad. Ibid.. 1929, 8: 1194-6. ---- Michigan, U. S. A. Michigan. Department of Health. An- nual report. Lansing, 1., 1873- ---- Michigan public health. Lansing, v.l, 1906- ---- Monthly bulletin of vital statistics. Lansing, v. 1-24, 1897-1921. ---- Reprint and supplement series. Lans- ing, Nos 2-589, 1876-1903. ---- Reprint series. Lansing, Nos 1-58, 1921-29. ---- Teachers sanitary bulletin. Lansing, v. 1-8, 1898-1905. Baker, H. B. The early history of Michigan's State Board of Health. J. Michigan M. Soc, 1916, 15: 424-7.—Olin, R. M. Making Michigan first in health. Mod. Med., Chic, 1921, 3: 108-10. ------ Public health in Michigan. Pub. Health Michigan, 1922, n. ser., 10: 671-7. ------ Protecting Michi- gan's health. Ibid., 805-24.-—Slemons, C. C. Michigan's Department of Health. J. Michigan M. Soc, 1932, 31: 133-5; 1934, 33: 29; 207.------The relationship of the Michigan Department of Health to the practicing physician. Ibid., 1937, 36: 141-9. Also Michigan Pub. Health, 1937, 25: 53-65.—Vaughan, V. C. The Michigan State Board of Health. J. Lab. Clin. M., 1918-19, 4: 504-10. --- Middlesex County, England. Middlesex County, Eng. Medical Officer of Health. Annual report. Lond., 1905- --- Middlesex County, New Jersey. Naulty, C. W. PubUc health service in Middlesex County. J. M. Soc. N. Jersey, 1920, 17: 83-5. ---- Middletown, New York. MlDDLETOWN, N. Y. BOARD OF HEALTH. Annual report. Middletown, 1915. ---- Milano, Italy. Bordoni-Uffreduzzi, G. I servizi di igiene nei comune di Milano; relazione al sindaco. 202p. 8? Milano, 1903. Milano, Italy. Comune di Milano. Annua- rio storico-statistico. Milano, 1914-25. ---- Milwaukee, Wisconsin. Milwaukee. Board of Public Works. Annual reports to the mayor and common council. 13v. 8? Milwaukee, 1891-1904. 227475—vol. 7, 4th series- -12 HEALTH ORGANIZATION 17S HEALTH ORGANIZATION Milwaukee, Wis. Health Department. Bulletin. Milwaukee, v.7, 1917- ---- Minneapolis, Minnesota. Minneapolis, Minn. Department of Health. Annual report. Minneup., 1888-1918. ---- Monthly bulletin. Minneap., v.l, 1917; 1919. ---- Official bulletin. Minneap., v.1-3, 1920-22. ---- Reports (monthly) Minneup., 1895 1903; 1910-11. ---- Minnesota, U. S. A. Minnesota. Department of Health [and Vital Statistics] Annual report. S. Paul, 1S73-1902; 1909-21. ---- Monthly bulletin. S. Paul, 1902-8; 1915-21. Minnesota. Department of Health. Pub- lic Health Nurses Services. Annual report. S. Paul, 1930-34. Bracken, H. M. A few facts relating to the Minnesota State Board of Health. J. Laneet. 1915, n. ser., 35: 11)8 12. ----A sketch of Minnesota Slate Board of Health work. St Paul M. J., 1917, 19: 17-20.- Wilson. L. B. The develop- ment of public health medicine in Minnesota. Proc. Mavo Clin., 1937, 12: 775- 83. ---- Mississippi, U. S. A. Mississippi. .State Board of Health. Biennial report. Jackson, 1., 1877-79; 1884-85; 1890-91; 1896- ---- Biennial report of factory inspection. Jackson, 11., 1929-31. ---- Monthly health bulletin. Jackson, v.l 10, 1910-22. ---- Health syllabus. Jackson, 1936. Underwood, F. J. Prop6sitos y trabajos del departamento de sanidad del estado de Misisipf. Bol. Of. san. panamer., Wash., 1937. 16:841-8. ---- Missouri, U. S. A. Missouri. State Board of Health. Quar- terly bulletin. Jefferson City, v.3-6, 1913-16. ---- Report [Jefferson City] 1888-1934. Missouri. State Board of Health. Divi- sion of Vital Statistics. Annual report of births, deaths, stillbirths, infant mortality and maternal death statistics. Jefferson City, 1921- ---- Annual report of deaths by accident. Jefferson City, 1., 1929. ---- Mobile, Alabama. Mobile, Ala. Board of Health. Annual reports. Mobile, 1871; 1875-76; 1889-94; 1900-1; 1914; 1936- ---- Monthly statement of mortality. Mo- bile, 1875-1902. ---- Montana, U. S. A. Montana. State Board of Health. Bi- ennial report. Helena, 1.-16., 1901-32; 20., 1937- ---- Bulletin. Helena, v.1-2, 1907-9; v.4-9, 1911-16; v.12, 1920. ---Health review. Helena, 1921-30. ----Montana health bulletin (quarterly) Helena, v.l, 1903-4 ---- Special bulletin. Helena, No. 1-47, 1914-33. ---- Montclair, New Jersey. Montclair, N. J. Department of Health, Annual report; health digest. Montclair, v.4, 1898- --- Montevideo, Uruguay. Urusro, L. 1>. El regimen sanitario del puerto de Monte- video y la KM:ui6n Sanitaria de la Isla de Flores. Bol. Cons. nac. hig., Montev., 1925, 20: 694-703. --- Montgomery, Alabama. Montgomery, Ala. Sanitary Department. Reports of the city physician (monthly) Mont- gomery, 1898-99. --- Montgomery County, Maryland. Montgomery County (Maryland) Health Department. Annual report. Rockville, 1935- --- Montreal, Quebec. Montreal. Department of Health, Health bulletin (Bulletin d'hygiene) Montreal, v.l, 1915- Report (annual) Montreal, 1882-83; 1885- Gagnon, E. Twenty years progress in the sanitary condi- tions of the City of Montreal. Bull, hyg., Montreal, 1935, 21: 2-14. Also Canad. Pub. Health J., 1936, 27: 160-4. —--- Notes on the early history and evolution of the Department of health of Montreal. Ibid., 1938, 29: 216-23.—Groulx, A. Developments in public health in Montreal during the past 3 years. Ibid., 1940, 31: 589-94.------Evolution d'une organisation sanitaire municipale et orientation nouvelle du service de sant6 de la ville de Montreal. Union mid. Canada, 1941, 70: 1087-96. ---- Morbihan (Dept.) France. Triollet. I/inspection d6partementale des services d'hy- giene du Morbihan. Ann. hyg., Par., 1937, n. ser., 15: 425-33. Also Rev. hyg. med. sociale, Par., 1937, 16: 235-42. ---- Morocco. Morocco. Direction de la sant£ et de l'hygiene publiques. Statistiques medicales annuelles. Casablanca 1927- Achard, C. L'ceuvre francaise, d'assainissenient. au Maroc. Bull. Acad, mid., Par., 1935, 3. ser., 115: 252-60—Colombani, J. L'organisation de la sant6 et de 1'hvgiSne publiques au Maroc. J. med. Bordeaux, 1929, 59: 526-34.—Dahir du 8 juillet 1938, relatif k I'assainissement des villes et des centres urbains; Bulletin Officiel du Maroc du 15 juillet 1938. Bull. Off. internat. hyg. pub., Par., 1938, 30: 2523-5.—D'Anfreville de la Salle, L. Un bureau d'hygidne d'outre-mer. Presse med., 1926, 34: 827. ---- Moskva, U. S. S. R. Moskau. Sanitaets-statistisches Bureau. Die Stadt Moskau in gesundheitlicher Beziehung. 131p. 8? Moskva, 1911. ---- Mount Vernon, New York. Mount Vernon, N. Y. Board of Health. Annual report. Mt. Vernon, 1910-11. 1--- Mysore, India. Mysore, India. State Department of Health. Annual report. Bangalore, 1911- --- Nancy, France. Nancy, France. Service municipal de medecine et d'hygiene. Annuaire de statis- tique et demographic Nancy, 1891-97; 1913-15; 1918-29; 1931- --- Napoli, Italy. Townsend, J. G., & Buonocore, E. Public health organiza- tion and administration in Naples, Italy. Pub. Health Rep., Wash., 1932, 47: 2328-54.—Tropeano, G. La pubblica assistenza a Napoli; rilievi e proposte. Med. sociale. Nap., 1923, 13: 117-22. ---- Narragansett, Rhode Island. Narragansett (District of) R. I. A manual of sanitary rules and regulations. 17p. 12? Wakefield, 1889. HEALTH ORGANIZATION 179 HEALTH ORGANIZATION ---- Nashville, Tennessee. Nashville, Tenn. Board of Health. Annual report, Nashville, 1., 1874/75- 1878; 1893-1915. ---- Natick, Massachusetts. Natick, Mass. Board of Health. Annual report. Natick, 1895; 1897-1900; 1902-3. ---- Nebraska, U. S. A. Nebraska. Department of Health and Public Welfare. Biennial report. Lincoln, 1920-22; 1926-30. ---- Quarterly bulletin. Lincoln, v.2-4, 1915-17. Fox, C. Pubhc health administration in Nebraska. Pub. Health Rep., Wash., 1916, 31: 1750-75.—Miller. A. L. Prob- lems of the State Health Department. Nebraska M. J., 1941, 26- 313-7.—Rowe, E. W. The new health department of Nebraska. Ibid., 1917, 2: 303-8.—Wild, W. F. Report of the Department of Health. Ibid., 1918, 3: 173-5. ---- The Netherlands. [Netherlands] Centrale Gezondheids- raad. Maandblad [Utrecht] 1919-20. [Netherlands] Staatstoezicht op de volks- gezondheid. Jaarverslag. 's-Gravenhage, 1902- 20. Chevalier de la Croix. [Annual report for 1936-37 of the chief inspector of the public health] Groene & witte kruis, 1939, 35: 138.—Faber, L. A. [Cooperative ideas, applied in the field of pubhc health] Ned. tschr. geneesk., 1940, 84: 4582-5 — Horst, M. D. [The establishment of public health service] Geneesk. gids, 1941, 19: 140-7.—Loghem, J. J. van [Pubhc health service in Netherlands] Arch. mid. sociale, Brux., 1939, 2: 967-99.—[Report of the treasury commission on the financial status of the assistance fund of the Netherlands Public Health Commission] Ned. tschr. geneesk., 1940, 84: 1787. ---- Netherlands East Indies. Nederlandsch-Indie. Dienst der volks- gezondheid. Mededeelingen. Weltevreden, v.4, 1917- ---- Verslagen der volksgezondheid. Welte- vreden, 1924- [Annual report on the Public Health Service for 1934] Meded. dienst volksgez. Ned. Indie, 1935, 24: 404-60.—[An- nual report of the Netherlands Indies Pubhc Health Service for the year 1935] Ibid., 1936, 25: 347-88.—[Annual report of the Netherlands Indies Public Health Service for the year 1936] Ibid., 1938, 27: 310-72.—[Annual report of the Nether- lands Indies Public Health Service for the year 1938] Ibid., 1940, 29: 111-74.—[Brief report on the activity of the Public Health Commission for the year 1936] Versl. volksgezondh., 1937, 325-94.—Dinger, J. E. [Public health service in war time] Geneesk. tschr. Ned. Indie, 1940, 80: 2830-42 — Heinemann, H. [Hygienic work of the Senembah-Society during the recent years] Ibid., 1935, 75: 524-33.—Loghem, J. J. van [Public health care in the Dutch Indies] Ned. tschr. geneesk., 1936, 80: 5069-86, 2 pl. ---- Netherlands West Indies. Nederlandsch-Indle. Suriname en Cura- cao Koloniale Reserve. Statistisch overzicht van de behandelde zieken der koloniale troepen. 's-Gravenhage, 1914 35. ---- Nevada, U. S. A. Nevada. State Board of Health. Bi- ennial report. Carson City, 1899- ---- Statistical bulletin. Carson City, Nos 3-7, 1921-25; No. 12, 1934. Fox, C. Public health administration in Nevada. Pub. Health Rep., Wash., 1915, 30: 3802-23. ---- Newark, New Jersey. Newark, N. J. Department of Health. Annual report. Newark, 1880-83; 1885-89; 1894; 1897-1902; 1902-29. --- Monthly bulletin. Newark, 1917-27. --- Weekly report. 1900-16. ---Health review for the City of Newark covering the depression years 1930-35. 53p. 4? Newark, 1936. ---- New Bedford, Massachusetts. New Bedford, Mass. Board of Health. Annual report. New Bedford, 1., 1879- ---- New Britain, Connecticut. New Britain, Conn. Board of Health. Annual reports. New Britain, 11., 1917; 19., 1924/25- --- City health news. New Britain, 1931- 32. ---Monthly bulletin. New Britain, 1927; 1929-30. --- New Brunswick, Canada. New Brunswick. Department of Health. Annual report of the Chief Medical Officer to the Minister of Health. Fredericton, N. B., 1918- Warwick, W. The development of public health in New Brunswick. Canad. Pub. Health J., 1935, 26: 168-75.------ Full-time health districts in New Brunswick. Ibid., 1939, 30: 284-7. ---- Newburgh, New York. Newburgh, N. Y. Board of Health. An- nual report. Newburgh, 1867-69; 1879-1911; 1913-18; 1920-22; 1924-29; 1931. ---- Newburyport, Massachusetts. Newburyport, Mass. Board of Health. Municipal reports (annual) Newburyport, 1879- 81; 1888; 1895-96; 1900-24. ---- Newcastle-upon-Tyne, Great Britain. Newcastle-Upon-Tyne, Great Britain. Medical Officer of Health. Annual report. Newcastle, 1877- ---- Newfoundland and Labrador. Newfoundland & Labrador. Department of Public Health and Welfare. Census. St John's [1935] 1936. Squires, S. Public health in Newfoundland. Canad. Nurse, 1940, 36: 13-6. —:— New Hampshire, U. S. A. New Hampshire. State Board of Health. Annual report. Concord, 1., 1882- ---Health (monthly) Concord, 1923- ----Quarterly bulletin. Concord, v. 1-6, 1912-22. ---- Registration report. Concord, 1882- ----Sanitary bulletin. Concord, v. 1-3, 1900-11. Duncan, C. State, county and town health administration in New Hampshire as recommended by the Brookings Institute survey. Proc. Conf. Health Author. N. America, 1933, 48: 20-35. ---- New Haven, Connecticut. New Haven, Conn. Department of Health. Annual reports. New Haven, v.l, 1873- ----Health. New Haven, v.51, 1924- ----Monthly bulletin. New Haven, v.42-51, 1913-24. ---- New Jersey, U. S. A. New Jersey. Department of Health. Annual report. Trenton, 1., 1877- --- Circular. Trenton, No. 27-110, 1886- 1905. ---- Public health news. Trenton, v.l, 1915- HEALTH ORGANIZATION ISO HEALTH ORGANIZATION New Jersey. State Sanitary Commission. Report, Trenton [1S66] 1867. Nichols. S. H. Report of the special committee on public health. J. M. Soc. N. Jersey, 1934, 31: 286-8.------An- nual report of the Sub-Committee on Public Health. Ibid., 1941. 38: 241.—Outcalt. E. R. Expansion of New Jersey's health program through social security funds. Pub. Health News, Trenton, 1938, 22: 348-52. --- New Mexico, U. S. A. New Mexico. Bureau of Public Health. Biennial report. Santa Fe\ 2., 1921- ---- New Mexico health officer. Santa Fe, v.4-8, 1934-38. Public health. Santa Fe\ v.4, 1934- ----Weekly bulletin. Santa F6, 1921-29. Fox, P. S. Districting New Mexico for sanitation. Am. J. Pub. Health, 1939, 29: 910.—Kerr, J. W. Public health administration in New Mexico. Pub. Health Rep., Wash., 1918, 33: 1976-95.—Luckett, G. S. Health work in New Mexico is 5 years old. Nation's Health, Chic, 1924, 6: 745; 813.—Varied health problems of our many states; New Mexico. Pub. Health Nurse, 1919, 11: 428-35.—Waller, C. E. Plans and personnel of the recently created New Mexico State Board. Am. J. Pub. Health, 1919, 9: 783. --- New Orleans, Louisiana. New Orleans, La. Board of Health. Biennial report, N. Orleans, 1900-26. Monthly bulletin. N. Orleans, 1905-14; I9IS-30. Quarterly report. N. Orleans, 1905. ---- Newport, Rhode Island. Newport, R. I. Board of Health. Annual reports. Newport, 1885-92; 1895-97; 1901; 1903-10; 1912-20; 1925- ---- Statements of mortality (monthly) Newport, 1888-1907; 1913- ---- New South Wales, Australia. New South Wales. Department of Pub- lic Health. Report of the director-general of public health. Sydney, 1897-98; 1913- Armstrong, W. G. The establishment of a central health authority in New South Wales. Med. J. Australia, 1937, 1: 400-5.—Black. G. The health ministry of New South Wales. Ibid., 1916, 1: 128.—Health administration in New South Wales. Med. Off., Lond., 1938, 59: 187. --- Newton, Massachusetts. Newton, Mass. Department of Health. Annual report. Newton, 1888- --- Bulletin (monthly) Newton, 1914- --- New York (City) N. Y. Brooklyn Eagle Library. The sanitary code of the Board of Health of the Department of Health of the City of New York. fol. Brook lyn. 1900. Drolet, G. J., & Potter, M. P. Health center districts, New York City; handbook: statistical reference data; 5-year period, 1929-33 3. ed. 140p. 4? N. Y., 1935. New York, N. Y. Department of Health Annual report. N. Y., 1866-80; 1889- ---- Collected studies from the Research laboratory. N. Y., v.l, 1905-26. ---- Monograph series. N. Y., Nos 1-15 1912-16; Nos 17-18, 1917; No. 23, 1920. ---- Monthly bulletin. N. Y , v 1-18 1911-27. ---- Quarterly bulletin. N. Y., v.l, 1933- —— Quarterly reports. N. Y., 1901-10. ---- Reprint series. Nos 1-102, 1915-28. ---- School health news. N. Y v 4-10 1918-25. ---- Summary of results of 54 years of public health work. N. Y., 1921. ---- Summary of vital statistics. N. Y., 1898-1934. - Vital statistics report, N. Y., 1S76 80; 1S.N9 1923; 1925 31. ---- Weekly bulletin. N. Y., v.l 21, 1S9I 1932. New York, N. Y. Department of Health. Bureau of Preventable Diseases. Rules for employees of the Bureau of Preventable Diseases, including those for all employees; directories of offices, tuberculosis clinics and hospitals, and supply stations. 106p. 32? [n. p.] 1915. New York, N. Y. Department of Health. Committee on Neighborhood Health De- velopment. Statistical reference data, 5 year period (1929-33) 140p. 4? N. Y., 1935. New York (Port) N. Y. Department of Health. Report of the health officer of the Port. Alb., 1886; 1889-90; 1892-93; 1896-99; 1901; 1914-19. New York Academy of Medicine. Public Health Committee. The Public Health Com- mittee of the New York Academy of Medicine; a survey of its activities during five years of work, 1911-16. 106p. 8? N. Y. [1916] Centralisation (La) des travaux relatifs k la sant6 publique k New York. Rev. hyg., Par., 1919, 41: 936-58.—District health administration in New York City. Q. Bull. Milbank Mem. Fund, 1933, 11: 208-20.—Emerson, H. A health pro- gram for New York City. N. York M. J., 1915, 102: 393-0. ------ The responsibilities of the Department of Health of the city of New York. Long Island M. J., 1916, 10: 261-6.— Monaghan, F. J. Work of the Sanitary Bureau during 1921. Month. Bull. Dep. Health City New York, 1922, 12: 153-65.— Rice, J. L., & Barnard, M. W. Four years of district health administration in New York City. Milbank Mem. Fund Q., 1938, 16: 253-66.—Smith, S. The origin and organization of the Department of Health of the city of New York. Med. Rec, N. Y., 1918, 93: 1115-7.—Widdemer, K. D. Future health development in neighborhood areas in Greater New York. Tr. Nat. Tuberc. Ass., N. Y., 1940, 36: 167-74 [Dis- cussion] 181-4.—Wile, I. S. The service and plight of the New York Health Department. Survey, N. Y., 1918, 40: 63. ------ Who is incompetent; a new phase in the offensive against the health administration of New York Citv. Ibid. 448. --- New York (State) U. S. A. New York. Department of Health. Annual report. Albany, N. Y., 1: 1881- ---- Health news. Alb., N. Y., 1914-23. ---- Health news. N. Y., 1: 1924- ---- Monthly bulletin. Alb., N. Y., 1893- 1914. New York. State Department of Health. Division of Laboratories. Annual report. Alb., N. Y., 1920- New York. State Department of Health. Division of Publicity and Education. Pro- ceedings; annual conference of sanitary officers. Alb., N. Y., 6.-14., 1906-14. New York. State Department of Health. Division of Vital Statistics. Annual report, Alb., N. Y., 1880- ---- Monthly vital statistical review. Alb., N. Y., 1920- Biggs, H. M. The public health council of the State of New York. Med. Rec, N. Y., 1915, 88: 125. ------ The State Board of Health. N. York State J. M., 1921, 21: 6-9 — Brooks, P. B. The scoring of health activities in cities of New York State. Am. J. Pub. Health, 1919, 9: 436-9.—Parran, T. A-new health program for New York State. J. Am. M. Ass., if31'97: 763-6—Progress in state public health work in 1936. Health News, Alb., 1937, 14: 105.—Winslow, C. E. A. Educa- tional work of the New York State Department of Health. Med. Rec, N. Y., 1915, 88: 126. --- New Zealand. New Zealand. Department of Health. Report of the director-general of health. Well- ington, 1920- HEALTH ORGANIZATION Health services in New Zealand. Brit. M. J., 1940, 1: Suppl., 37. --- Niagara Falls, New York. Niagara Falls, N. Y. Bureau of Health. Annual report. Niagara Falls, 1901; 1903-5; 1917-24. --- Nigeria. Nigeria. Medical and Sanitary Service- Report. Lagos, 1914- Public health work in the Colonv and Protectorate of Nigeria during 1937. J. Trop. M. Hyg., Lond., 1939, 42: 382-7.—Recent advances in public health in Nigeria. Ibid., 1936, 39: 279. --- Norfolk, Virginia. Norfolk, Va. Board of Health. Monthly report. Norfolk, 1912-25. ---• Norristown, Pennsylvania. Norristown, Pa. Board of Health. An- nual report. Norristown, 1891-92; 1894-1908; 1910-19. --- North Adams, Massachusetts. North Adams, Mass. Board of Health. Annual report, North Adams, 2.-4., 1897-99; 8.-32., 1903-27; 41.-45., 1935-39. --- Northampton, England. Northampton, Eng. Medical Officer of Health. Report. Northampton, 1905-35. Northampton, Eng. School Medical Offi- cer. Annual report. Northampton, 1922- --- Northampton, Massachusetts. Northampton, Mass. Board of Health. Annual report. Northampton, 12.-49., 1895- 1932; 52., 1935- --- Northamptonshire County, England. Northamptonshire County, Eng. Medical Officer of Health. Annual report. North- ampton, 1897- --- North Carolina, U. S. A. North Carolina. State Board of Health. Annual bulletin of morbidity statistics. Raleigh, v.l, 1918- ---- Biennial report. Raleigh, 1879- ---- Health bulletin. Raleigh, v.7, 1893- ---- Reports. Raleigh, 1., 1879-80; 1885- North Carolina. State Board of Health. Bureau of Vital Statistics. Annual report. Raleigh, 1922- Fox, R. E. The development of local health service in North Carolina. Health Bull., Raleigh, 1937, 52: No. 6, 6-8 -----Local health service in North Carolina today. Ibid.,' 1939, 54: No. 1, 6-9. Hamilton, J. H., & Milam, D. F. Twenty vears of county health work in North Carolina. South. M. J., 1934, 27: 875-80.—Norton, R. A quarter-century of health progress in North Carolina. North Carolina M. J., 1940, 1: 529-34.—Parrott, J. M. Annual report; North Carolina board of health. South. M. & S., 1932, 94: 290-4.—Service to the people; what the State Board of Health has to offer to the people of North Carolina. Health Bull., Ralegh, 1923, 38: No. 5, 4-9. --- North Dakota, U. S. A. North Dakota. State Department of Health. Biennial report. Bismarck, 3.-5., 1893-97; 7.-13., 1901-14; 15., 1917- Olesen, R. Report of a survey of pubhc health administra- tion in North Dakota. Pub. Health Rep., Wash., 1922, 37: 3021-39.—Whittemore, A. A. An outline of the history of public health in North Dakota. J. Lancet, 1931, 51: 351. --- Norway. Norway. Direktoren for det civile Medicinalvaesen. Sundhedstilstanden og me- dicinal Wholdene. Oslo, 1897- HEALTH ORGANIZATION Hoyer, W. A. Das offentliche Gesundheitswesen in Nor- svegen. Veroff. Medverwalt., 1930, 32: 193-408. --- Nottingham, England. Nottingham, Eng. Medical Officer of Health. Annual report on the health of the city. Nottingham, 1893- --- Nova Goa, Port. India. Froilano de Mello, I. Le service de Sante & l'lnde portu- gaise (1929) Arq. Esc. med. cir. Nova Goa, 1933, ser. B, 784-829.—Trabalhos da Comissao executiva do fomento do Concelho de Sanguem; relat6rio. Ibid., 1937, ser. B, 1682-704 4 tab. ---- Novara, Italy. Giuffrida, G. Condizioni sanitarie del comune di Novara e servizi di igiene e saniti negli anni 1936 e 1937. Osp. maggiore Novara, 1938, 15: 185-201. --- Nova Scotia, Canada. Nova Scotia, Canada. Department of Public Health. Report. Halifax, 1899- Campbell, P. S., & Scammell, H. L. The development of public health in Nova Scotia. Canad. Pub. Health J., 1939 30: 226-38.—DeWitt, C. E. A. Some public health needs in Nova Scotia. Ibid., 1938, 29: 373-6.—MacRitchie, J. J. Pubhc Health work in Nova Scotia. Nat. Health Rev., Ottawa, 1936-37, 4: 33. --- Nyasaland Protectorate. Nyasaland. Medical Department. An- nual medical and sanitary report. Zomba, Nyasaland, 1913- ---- Oakland, California. Oakland, Calif. Board of Health. An- nual reports. Oakland, 1873/74-1905/6. ---- Monthly bulletins. Oakland, 1914-22. ---- Vital statistics (monthly) Oakland, 1898-1913. ---- Odessa, U. S. S. R. Odessa, U. S. S. R. Board of Health. Medical report. Odessa, 1913. ---- Ohio, U. S. A. Ohio Industrial Commission. Division of Safety and Hygiene. Annual statistical report. Columbus, 1933; 1934. Ohio. State Department of Health. Annual report. Columbus, 1.-31., 1885-1929. --- Monthly bulletin. Columbus, v.1-4, 1911-14. ---Ohio health news. Columbus, v.l, 1925- --- Ohio public health journal. Columbus, v.5-16, 1915-25. ---Ohio sanitary bulletin. Columbus, v.1-12, 1895-1908. ---Quarterly bulletin. Columbus, v.1-2, 1909-10. Ohio. State Department of Public Wel- fare. Annual report. Columbus, 2.-12., 1923-33. Bauman, J. E. Thirty years in public health work in Ohio. Rep. Proc. Am. Soc. San. Engin. (1918-21) 1922, 429-36.— Freeman, A. W. Four years' progress in public health organ- ization in Ohio. J. Am. M. Ass., 1921, 77: 1639-41.—Hay- hurst, E. R. The new program under the Ohio Department of Health. Indust. M., 1936, 5: 411.—Markwith, R. H. Ac- tivities and program of the State Department of Health. Ohio M. J., 1939, 35: 853-5.—Paterson, R. G. Organization for public health in Ohio. Nation's Health, Chic, 1921, 3: 590-3.—Shaffer, E. R. Expenditures per capita for health work in the rural districts in Ohio. Am. J. Pub. Health, 1927, 17: 1008-14. ---- Oil City, Pennsylvania. Oil City, Pa. Board of Health. Annual report. Oil City, 1895-96; 1898-99; 1901-2; 1904-5; 1907. HEALTH ORGANIZATION 1S2 HEALTH ORGANIZATION ---- Oise (Dept.) France. Oise (Dept.) France. Conseil central d'hygiene et de salubrite. Travaux. Bcau- vais. 1894-1904. ---- Oklahoma, U. S. A. Oklahoma. State Board of Health. An- nual report. Oklahoma City, 1.-2., 1915-17; 4.-5., 1919-21; 9., 1927-28; 1933-34. — Biennial report. Oklahoma City, 1891-1900, 1909-12. Duke, J. W. Advances in public health work in our State (Oklahoma) during the past year. South. M. J., 1917, 10: 788-93. ---- Oklahoma City, Oklahoma. Oklahoma City and County, Okla. Board of Health. Bulletin. Oklahoma Citv, v.1-3, 1920-22. ---- Oldham, England. Oldham, Eng. Medical Officer of Health. Report. Oldham, 1873-1904; 1911-35. ---- Omaha, Nebraska. Omaha, Xebr. Board of Health. Annual health bulletin. Omaha, 1938-40. ---- Annual report. Omaha, 1892-1904; 1918-19; 1938- ---- Health bulletin. Omaha, v.4, No. 1, 1941- Monthly report. Omaha, 1894-96. ---- Omdurman, Anglo-Egypt. Sudan. See in this list Khartoum. ---- Ontario, Canada. Ontario, Canada. Department of Health. Annual report. Toronto, 1., 1882- ----Health almanac. Toronto, 1935. Development iTho of pubhc health in Ontario. Canad. I'ub. Health J., 1935. 26: 110-23.—McCann, J. J. Some public health activities and needs in Ontario. Ibid., 1934, 25: 255-9.—Mclntyre, H. Smne aspects of health administration m Noithern Ontario. Hud., 1936, 27: 592-6. ---- Orange, New Jersey. Orange, N. J. Board of Health. Annual report. Orange, 1908-20. ---- Oregon, U. S. A. Oregon. State Board of Control. Bi- ennial report. Portland, 1., 1912/14- Oregon. State Board of Health. Annual report, Portland, 190S-20. ---- Biennial report. Portland, 1.-16., 1903-33; 1938-39- ---- Oregon health. Portland, v.1-11, 1907- 22. ---- Oslo, Norway. Oslo, Norway. Helserad. Beretning. Oslo, 1910- ---- Ottawa, Ontario. Ottawa, Ont. Medical Officer of Health. Annual report. Ottawa, 1908- ---- Paddington, England. Paddington, Eng. Medical Officer of Health. Report. Paddington, 1896; 1911- ---- Paisley, Scotland. Paisley, Scot. Public Health Depart- ment. Report (annual) Paisley, 1930-32. ---- Palestine. Palestine. Health Department. Animal report. Jerusalem, 1., 1921- Canaan. Die sanitaren Einrichtungen Paliistinas. Deut. med. Wschr., 1925, 51: 1242.—Diringer. 1>. Un breve cenno sui servizi sanitari ed igienici nella Palcstina (con particolare riguardo all'attivit& ebraica) Arch. ital. sc. med. colon., 1934, 15: 195-204— Friedenwald, H. The sanitary problems of Palestine. Bull. Univ. Maryland School M., 1919-2(1, 4: 215-21.—Olitzki, L. Die sanitaren Einrichtungen Paliistinas. Deut. med. Wschr., 1925, 51: 402. ---- Palo Alto, California. Palto Alto, Calif. Health Department. Annual report. Palto Alio, v.l, 1909/10- ---- Panama. Panama. Departamento de sanidad y beneficiencia. Boletin sanitario. Panama, 1., 1935- Panama. Secretario de Estado. Memoria (higiene, beneficiencia y fomento) Panama, 1912; 1938- Curry, D. P. Sanitation in Panama. J. Am. M. Ass., 1922. 79: 910. ---- Panama Canal, U. S. A. See in this list Canal Zone. ---- Panamerican and Latin American. See also names of Panamerican sanitary insti- tutions. Araoz Alfaro, G. La politica sanitaria en los paises sud- americanos. Sem. mid., B. Air., 1923, 30: 388-90.—Comi- siones t^cnicas de la Oficina sanitaria Panamericana: nutrici6n, paludismo, c6digo sanitario tipo. Bol. Of. san. panamer., 1940, 19: 920.—Coni, E. R. La administraci6n sanitaria y asistencia pdblica en los pafses latino-americanos. Sem. mid., B. Air., 1920, 27: 207; 233; 339.—Crane, J. L., jr. Sanitation in Venezuela and Colombia. Am. J. Pub. Health, 1921, 11: 145-8.—Creacion de Protomedicato o de Tribunal Medico Centroamericano; proyecto de ley para los menores fue some- tido ayer; mensaje a la delegaci6n de farmacia; interesantes trabajos del Doctor Escalante y Coronel Alfaro. Bol. san. Guatemala, 1938, 9: 558.— Gumming, H. S. Cooperaci6n internacional en sanidad: su desenvolviiniento y estado actual; algunos resultados de las modernas modidas preventivas. Bol. Of. san. panamer., 1933, 12: 1191-203.------Develop- ment of international cooperation among the health authorities of the American republics. Am. J. Pub. Health, 1938, 28: 1193-6. Also Mil. Surgeon, 1938, 83: 1-6.—Ernst, E. C, & Marquez, G. Pioyccio dc escalafon sanitario. Bol. Of. san. panamer., 1939, 18: 625 36.—Health and sanitation in cities of South America. Q. Bull. Louisiana Bd Health, 1923, 14: 47-52.—Long, J. D. Kelaeiones de la Oficina Sanitaria Pan- americana con la liga de las Sociedades de la Cruz Roja. Pol. Of. san. panamer., 1924, 3: 10-5.------Obras de sanidad panamericana; informe anual. Ibid., 1932, 11: 1027.----- Cooperation between the countries of Latin America and the United States and States of the United States. Proc. Conf. Health Author. N. America, 1940, 55. moot., 29 32.—Negre, L. L'organisation sanitaire et l'hygiene en Bepnbli<|ue Argentine, au Chili, en Uruguay et au Bresil. Rev. h\g., Par., 1928, 50: 481-520.- Powell, H. J. B. Sanitary progress in Peru and Bolivia. J. H. San. Inst., 1915-16, 36: 394-403.—Sanidad (La) y los gobernantes. Bol. Of. san. panamer., 1934, 13: 691-7.—Trigueros, G. Proyecto para la foi maci6n de un protomedicato o tribunal medico sanitario en Centro America y en Panama. Bol. san. Guatemala, 1938, 9: 373 92. ---- Paraguay. Paraguay. Departamento nacional de higiene y asistencia publica. Memoria ... al anode 1922. 58p. 8? Asunci6n, 1923. Masi, C. Labor realizada por el Departamento nacional de higiene y asistencia publica del Paraguav. Actas Conf. san. panamer., 1934, 10. Conf., 485-7.—Mendoza, P. de la C. Policia sanitaria; antecedentes y proyecto de legislaci6n en el Paraguay. Rev. zoot£cn., B. Air., 1920, 7: 1--23 —Urizar, R. Report. Tr. Internat. San. Conf. Am. Repub., 1911, 5. Conf., 119. ---- Parana, Brazil. Campos Mello, L. Veintium mezes de saude publica no Parani; Janeiro de 1938 a septembro de 1939 Fol med Rio, 1940, 21: 23; 98; p. iii. HEALTH ORGANIZATION 183 HEALTH ORGANIZATION ---- Paris, France. Guillermond, G. Les services d'hygiene de la ville de Paris en 1908. 108p. 8? Par., 1908. Paris, France. Direction de l'hygiene, du travail et de la prevoyance sociale. anilu- aire statistique. Par., 14., 1893- ---- Bulletin decadaire de statistique muni- cipale. Par., v.l, 1920-33. --- Pasadena, California. Pasadena, Calif. Department of Health. Annual report. Pasadena, 1919-29; 1932- --- Paterson, New Jersey. Paterson, N. J. Board of Health. Annual report, Paterson, 1891-1901; 1904-5; 1908-14; 1921-22; 1927-30. --- Monthly report. Paterson, 1890-1901; 1904- --- Pawtucket, Rhode Island. Pawtucket, R. I. Board of Health. An- nual report, Pawtucket, 1911-20; 1928; 1930- --- Pennsylvania, U. S. A. Allen, W. H. *Rural sanitary administra- tion in Pennsylvania. 93p. 8? [n. p., ca 1900] Pennsylvania. Department of Health. Biennial report. Harrisb., 1., 1928-30. --- Listening post. Harrisb., v. 1-5, 1922- 27. --- Pennsylvania health. Harrisb., v.5, 1927- --- Report (annual) Harrisb., 1.-20., 1885-1905. ---- Reports of the commissioner of health. Harrisb., 1.-11., 1905-16. --- Vital statistics bulletin. Harrisb., v.l, 1926- --- Yearbook. Harrisb., v.l 3, 1929-31. Stevenson, W. L. Engineering bureau of the Pennsylvania Department of Health. Tr. Internat. Conf. San. Engin., 1924, 1. Congr., 21-9. --- Peoria, Illinois. Peoria, III. Department of Health, Annual report, Peoria, 1897-1917; 1937-39. ---Peoria health news. Peoria, 1939- --- Perlis, Malaya. See in this list Kedah. --- Peru. Paz Soldan, C. E. Un programa nacional de politica sanitaria. 38p. 8? Lima, 1916. Avendafio, L. Las plantaciones en la red urbana; informe t^cnico administrativo. Cron. mid., Lima, 1909, 26: 137-44.— Cardenas Sinclair, Z. Organizacion y funciones del Departa- mento municipal de sanidad. Ibid., 1938, 55: 352-7.—Coloniza- cion (La) en seguridad sanitaria de nuestro Oriente amazonico. Reforma mid., Lima, 1940, 26: 510-26.—Coni, E. R. La Administracion Sanitaria y Asistencia Publica en los paises latino-americanos, 2: Peru. Sem. m6d., B. Air., 1920, 27: 309-12.—Desenvolvirr iento de la Sanidad de policia en sus aspectos t6cnico y administrativo. Rev. san. policfa, Lima, 1941, 1: 47.—Kuczynski-Godard, M. H. La supervisi6n sanitaria de la Selva. Reforma m6d., Lima, 1940, 26: 665; 697; 755; pl.—Nuevo (El) edificio del Ministerio de salud publica, trabajo y prevision social. Ibid., 1939, 25: 829-31, illust.—Olaechea, A. S. Situacion de la sanidad y asistencia en el Peru. Cr6n. med., Lima, 1933, 50: 49; 82; 108; 141; 182. --- Petersburg, Virginia. Petersburg, Va. Health Department. Report (monthly) Petersburg, 1897-99; 1901; 1914- --- Philadelphia, Pennsylvania. Philadelphia. Pa, Department of Public Health. Annual report. Phila., 1860-1923. ---Health bulletin. Phila., 1940- ----Monthly bulletin. Phila., 1914-35. ----Quarterly bulletin. Phila., 1936- --- Weekly returns. Phila., 1873-1913. Organization and functions of the Department of Pubhc Health of Philadelphia. Q. Bull. Philadelphia Dep. Pub Health, 1937, July-Dec, 2-35. ---- Philippine Islands, U. S. A. Phillippine Islands. Bureau of Public Health. Annual report. Manila, 1903-38. --- Health bulletin. 32p. 8? Manila (1903) 1904. ---- Monthly bulletin of the Philippine Islands health service. Manila, v.l, 1921- - — Monthly reports. Manila, 1901-5. Quarterly report. Manila, 1906-21. ---- Synopses of the annual reports for the years 1930, 1931 and 1932. Manila, 1934. Abellana Basa, J. Los principios de la sanidad piiblica moderna y su aplicacion pr&ctica en la labor sanitaria en Filipinas. Rev. filip. med. farm., 1920, 11: 293-306.—Aguilar, E. D. The public health service in the Philippines. J. Philip- pine M. Ass., 1940, 20: 1-13.—Budget (The) for 1922 with regard to the Philippine Health Service. Month. Bull. Philip- pine Health Serv., 1921, 1: 195-8.—Corpus, T. A survey of the Philippine Health Service personnel. Ibid., 1924, 4: 355-9.—DeLaney, M. A. Public health in the Philippine Islands. Army & Navy J., N. Y., 1933, 70: 671.—Fabella, J. Safeguarding the nation's health. J. Philippine Islands M. Ass., 1936, 16: 3-9.—Fajardo. J. El problema sanitario en Mindanao y Sula. Actas Asambl. reg. med. farm. Filipinas, 1917, 295-303.—Heiser, V. G. The Philippines and health ideals. Hygeia, Chic, 1923, 1: 140-4.—Intengan, G. His- torical review of health activities in the Philippine Islands. Tr. Far East. Ass. Trop. M. (1927) 1928, 1: 749-83, 10 pl — Lara, H. Development of hygiene and preventive medicine (public health) in the Philippines. Rep. Nat. Res. Counc. Philippine Islands, 1935, No. 1, 265-73. Also Filip. Nurse, 1937, 12: No. 4, 9-12.------Bibliography on Develop- ment of hygiene and preventive medicine (public health) in the Philippines. Rep. Nat. Res. Counc. Philippine Islands, 1935, No. 1, 273-90.—Lull, G. F. The development of the Philippine Health Service. Mil. Surgeon, 1931, 68: 204-10.— Nanagas, J. C. Cooperation necessary between medical as- sociations and the Government in the Philippines on legisla- tion pertaining to medical and public-health matters. J. Philippine Islands M. Ass., 1923, 3: 131-5.—Salud, E. The community health social center in the Philippines. Filip. Nurse, 1934, 9: No. 3, 10.—Sanitary progress in the Philip- pine Islands during 1922; the year in brief. Month. Bull. Philippine Health Serv., 1923, 3: 4-19.—Soberrano, F. Public health work in Camarines Norte. Month. Bull. Bur. Health, Manila, 1934, 14: 341-4. ---- Pittsburgh, Pennsylvania. Pittsburgh, Pa. Department of Public Health. Annual report, Pittsburgh, 1852-53; 1871-99; 1910-16. ---- Pittsburgh's health. Pittsburgh, v.5. 1937- ---- Pittsfield, Massachusetts. Pittsfield, Mass. Board of Health. Annual report, Pittsfield, 1869-70; 1891-98; 1900-1; 1904-5; 1908; 1910; 1912-13; 1915-16: 1918- ----Plainfield, New Jersey. Plainfield, N. J. Board of Health. An- nual report. Plainfield, 1902- Plainfield, N. J. City Council. Annual report of the City of Plainfield. Plainfield, 1913- ---- Poland. Aufbau (Der) des Gesundheitswesens im Generalgouverne- ment. Aerztebl. Hessen, 1940, 8: 62.—Bucek, F. [Notes on health ser\ice by the Captain of the health service, Dr Roubal] Voj. zdrav. listy, 1938, 14: 438-41.- Chatenay, G. La situa- tion sanitaire en Pologne. Rev. internat. Croix Rouge, 1920, 2: 1075-9.—Chodzko, W. La situation sanitaire en Pologne pendant les derniers mois de 1921 et les premiers de 1922. Bull. Off. internat. hyg. pub., Par., 1922, 14: 662-5. ------ Public health in the New Poland. World Health, Gen&ve, 1923, 4: No. 12, 1-5. ------ Les centres d'hvgiene en Pologne. Bull. Off. internat, hyg. pub., Par., 1929, 21: 1514-20, 1 ch.— HEALTH ORGANIZATION 1S4 HEALTH ORGANIZATION Frey. Die Organisation des Gcsundheitswesens im deutschen Verwalt nngsgebiet von Russisch-Polen. Zschr. iirztl. Fort- bild., 1917, 14: 131-6.------Das Gesundheitswesen im Deutschen Verwaltungsgebiet von Polen in den Jahren 1914-18. Arb. Reichsgesundhamt.. 1919, 51: 583-733.—Halliday, C. Con.linens in Poland, 1919-20. Mil. Surgeon, 1922, 51: 418-43. Mollers, B. Das offentliche Gcsuiidheitswesen in Polen. Reichsgesundhbl., 1935, 10: 16 9. Poznansky. S. [Organization of health-protection in Poland] Prof, med., Kharkov, 1927. 6: 122-6.- Szumowski. W. Le service de sant£ publique en Pologne. Presse mid., 1920, 28: (annexe) 985-92.—Thorns, H. Hygiene und Arzneiversorgung im Konigreich Polen. Arb. Pharm. Inst. Univ. Berlin, 1921, 12: 391-403.—Tubiasz, S. [Twenty years of public health service in restored Poland] W'arsz. czas. lek., 1938, 15: 733-9. --- Ponce, Puerto Rico. Ponce, P. R. Departamento de sanidad municipal. Report de los trabajos realizados. 50p. s° Ponce, 1904. --- Poplar, England. Poplar, Eng. Medical Officer of Health. Annual report on the sanitary condition and vital statistics. Poplar, 1905- ---- Portage County, New Jersey. Worden, R. D. Pubhc health work in Portage County. Ohio M. J., 1921, 17: 745-8. --- Port Huron, Michigan. Port Huron, Mich. Department of Health. Annual report. Port Huron, 1898- 1900; 1903-4. --- Portland, Maine. Portland, Me. Board of Health. Annual reports. Portland, 1887-1922. --- Portland, Oregon. Portland, Oreg. Bureau of Health. Annual report, Portland, 1897-1901; 1912-13; 1915-17; 1921; 1923; 1925-34. ---Monthly health bulletin. Portland, 1900-11; 1913-16. --- Monthly report, Portland, 1930- --- Portsmouth, England. Portsmouth, Eng. Medical Officer of Health. Health report. Portsmouth, 1888; 1S94- --- Poughkeepsie, New York. Poughkeepsie, X. Y. Board of Health. Annual report. Poughkeepsie, 1918-28. --- Monthly report. Poughkeepsie, 1919- 28. --- Preston, England. Preston, Eng. Medical Officer of Health Report. Preston, 1885-1938. --- Prince Edward Island. Keeping. B. C. The development of public health in Prince Edward Island. Canad. Pub. Health J., 1935, 26: 9-14. --- Providence, Rhode Island. Providence, R. I. Board of Health. Annual reports. Providence, 1856-57; 1884- Chapin, C. V. Sixty years of the Providence Health De- partment. Am. J. Pub. Health, 1916, 6: 90.5-15.—Nestor, M. J. Preliminary report of Health Department activities Providence, Rhode Island, 1940. Rhode Island M. J., 1941 24: 55. ---- Prussia, Germany. Gebietsbereinigungen in den ostlichen preussischen Pro- vinzen Reichsgesundhbl., 1938, 13: 305.—Gesundheitswesen (Das) des preussischen Staates in den Jahren 1923 und 1924 \crofT Medverwalt., 1926, 21: 181-365—Koenig. Der Gesundheitszustand in Preussen im Jahre 1924. Zschr. Medbeamte, 1926, 39: 23-46.—Mudgan. Zur Frage eines eigenen preussischen Ministcriums fiir Volksgesundheitspflege. Zschr. iirztl. Fortbild., 1918, 15: 327-9. --- Pueblo, Colorado. Pueblo, Colo. Department of Health. Annual report, Pueblo, 1900; 1904-7; 1921-27; 1936. ----Health; monthly bulletin. Pueblo, v.2-4, 1927-30. ---- Puerto Rico, U. S. A. Puerto Rico. Department of Health. Bulletin. San Juan, v.l, 1937- ---- Informe anual de la junta insular dc sanidad; suplemento del informe anual del director de sanidad. San Juan, 1912-13. ----Porto Rico health review. San Juan, v.1-2, 1925-27. ---- Porto Rico journal of public health and tropical medicine. San Juan, v.5, 1929- ---- Porto Rico review of public health and tropical medicine. San Juan, v.3-4, 1927-29. Report. San Juan, 1917-20; 1923; 1925-27; 1930; 1935-37. United States. War Department. Sur- geon General's Office. Military government of Porto Rico from October 18, 1898, to April 30, 1900; appendices to the report of the military governor; epitome of reports; I. The Superior Board of Health; II. The Board of Charities. 359p. 8? Wash., 1901. Chaves, J. Public health units as a part of the organiza- tion of the insular health department. Puerto Rico Health Bull., 1938, 2: 43-8.—Fernos-Isern, A. Health work in Porto Rico. Proc. Conf. Health Author. N. America, 1931, 46: 37-9.—Malaret, P. S. How our health depaitment functions. Bull. Dep. Health Puerto Rico, 1937, 1: 4.—Mcndez, R. M. Mechanism of the Division of Property and Accounts of the Health Department of Puerto Rico. Puerto Rico Health Bull., 1938, 2: 90. ---- Puerto Tejada, Colombia. Molina M., E. Informe de las labores realizadas por la unidad sanitaria de Puerto Tejada en el afio de 1937. Salud & san., Bogota, 1938, 7: No. 69, 2-6. --- Punjab, India. Punjab, India. Sanitary Board [Public Health Administration] Report on the sanitary administration and proceedings of the sanitary board. Lahore, 1868- Punjab, India. Sanitary Commissioner. Notes on vaccination. Lahore, 1920-21. --- Report on vaccination. Lahore, 1886- 1920. --- Quebec, Canada. Quebec, Canada. Provincial Bureau of Health. Annual report. Quebec, 1.-13., 1922-35. ---- Bulletin sanitaire. Montreal, v.l, 1901- ----Reports of the Board of Health. Quebec, 1.-28., 1895-1922. Development (The) of public health in the Province of Quebec. Canad. Pub. Health J., 1934, 25: 205-17.—Lessard. A- County health work in the Province of Quebec. Canad. J. M. & S., 1927, 62: 8-12.------Les unites sanitaires dans la province de Quebec. Nat. Health Rev., Ottawa, 1933, 1: 95_7- ------ Development of pubhc health administration in the province of Quebec. Am. J. Pub. Health, 1934, 24: y^-8- —--- Public health progress in Quebec. Canad. Pub. Health J., 1934, 25: 411-6.—Nadeau, E. A brief sum- mary of pubhc health progress in the Province of Quebec, during the last 30 years. Proc. Conf. Health Author. N. America, 1933, 48: 14-20.—Poulin, E. Un Ministere d'hy- giene pour la province de Quebec. Clinique, Montreal, 1922, j 1r4-—Vezina- L- R- Les Unites Sanitaires de comtes dans la Province de Quebec. Canad. Pub. Health J., 1930 HEALTH ORGANIZATION 185 HEALTH ORGANIZATION ---- Queensland, Australia. Queensland. Commissioner of Public Health. Annual report. Brisbane, 1912/13- Public health work in tropical Queensland. Nurs. Times, Lond., 1934, 30: 982. ---- Quincy, Illinois. • Fox, C. Public health administration in Quincy, 111. Pub. Health Rep., Wash., 1917, 32: 1665-79. ---- Quincy, Massachusetts. Quincy, Mass. Board of Health. Annual report. Quincy, 1899-1900; 1903; 1910-14. --- Raleigh, North Carolina. Raleigh, N. Car. Board of Health. Annual report. Raleigh, 1893-97; 1899-1902. Norton, R. Program planning in the local health depart- ment. Health Bull., Raleigh, 1937, 52: No. 7, 8-13. --- Rangoon, Burma. Rangoon, Burma. Health Officer. An- nual report. Rangoon, 1901- --- Reading, Pennsylvania. Reading, Pa. Board of Health. Annual report. Reading, 1874-1923. --- Bulletin. Reading, v.3-5, 1916-18. --- Recife, Pernambuco (Brazil) Britto, O. de. Os centros de saude de Recife. Ann. Congr. brasil. hyg., 1929, 5. Congr., 2: 119-23. ---Reims, France. Reims, France. Bureau d'hygiene. Rap- port annuel du directeur. Reims, 1927- --- Rhode Island, U. S. A. Rhode Island, U. S. A. Department of Public Health. Annual report. Providence, v.l, 1929/30- --- Annual report of the division of indus- trial hygiene. Providence, 1937. —— Annual reports of the State Board of health. Providence, 1878-1906; 1912-28. --- Bulletin. Providence, v.5-18, 1893- 1906; 1907-11; 1914-21; 1925-28. ---- Circular No. 41: Manual of the laws of Rhode Island, in relation to public health, and suggestions to health officers. 45p. 8? Provi- dence, 1886. Casey, T. B. State Department of Health, Division of Preventable Diseases. Rhode Island M. J., 1940, 23: 184 — Shea, W. J., Johnson, E. C, & Hammann, C. G. State De- partment of Health, Division of Sanitary Engineering. Ibid., 194-7. --- Richmond, Virginia. Richmond, Va. Department of Public Welfare. Annual report. Richmond, 1871- ---Monthly bulletin. Richmond, v.2-3, 1908-9. ---- Rio de Janeiro, Brazil. Rio de Janeiro. Secretaria geral de saude e assistencia. Boletim. Rio, v.2, 1936- Fontenelle, J. P. Evolucao da saude publica no Rio de Janeiro. Fol. med., Rio, 1937, 18: 557-61.—Pereira Gui- maraes, P. A saude publica no estado do Rio de Janeiro. Bol. Of. san. panamer., 1938, 17: 287-91.—Secretaria Geral de Saude e Assistencia do Distrito Federal. Arq. med. leg. ident., Rio, 1940, No. 18, 169-71. ---- Roma, Italy. Nico, A. Con l'autotreno sanitario nella provincia di Roma. Stomat. ital., 1940, 2: 77-9. ---- Rumania. Gottlieb, M. *Apercu de l'hygiene publique et sociale en Roumanie. 50p. 8? Par., 1933. Cantacuzene, J. La situation sanitaire actuelle de la Roumanie. Bull. Off. internat. hyg. pub., Par., 1922, 14: 1523-6.—Committees appointed by the Ministry of health (Rumania) J. Am. M. Ass., 1939, 113: 2073.—Daniel, C. La santS publique en Roumanie. Rev. mid. fr., 1925, 6: 215.—Mezincescu, D. [Actual condition of our sanitary organization and ways of improving it] Romania med., 1932, 10: 199.—Naville, C. La situation sanitaire en Roumanie. Rev. internat. Croix Rouge, 1920, 2: 1064-74.—Pascal, V. [Criticism of the public health service] Rev. st. med., Bucur., 1935, 24: 1209-1351.—Public (The) health balance of the past year [Rumania] J. Am. M. Ass., 1941, 116: 884.—Samarian, P. [Unedited documents by medical specialists of the Rou- manian Public Health Service, 1832-34] Rev. st. med., Bucur., 1937, 26: 307-23.—State of public health in Rumania. J. Am. M. Ass., 1939, 112: 2548. ---- Russia. Gutkin, A. J. [Health preservation in Soviet Russia for 10 years (1917-1927)] 56p. 8? [Leningr., 1927] Haines, A. J. Health work in Soviet Russia. 177p. 12? N. Y., 1928. Rubakine, A. Protection of the public health in the U. S. S. R. 47 1. 4? [n. p., 1932] ---- The same. La protection de la sante publique dans l'U. R. S. S. (principes et resul- tats) 91p. 8° Par., 1933. Russia. Ministry of Interior. Bureau of the Chief Medical Inspector (Report on the condition of public health and the organiza- tion of medical aid in Russia) St Peterburg, 1896-1911. Russia. Ministry of the Interior. Medi- cal council [Activity of the Medical council for 1881] 8? St Peterburg, 1884. Semashko, N. A. Health protection in the U. S. S. R. 176p. 8? Lond., 1934. Baran, N. A. [Sanitary order in medical prophylactic institutions] Gig. san., Moskva, 1940, 5: No. 9, 1-4.—Barsu- kov, M. [Health protection in White Russia by nationalities] Bieloruss. med. dumka, 1925-26, 2: 3-11.—Believ, J. [How the sanitary organization ought to be built on the 5-year plan with a district or section budget] Profil. med., Kharkov, 1928, 7: No. 4, 129-34.—Bloch. I. S. [Sanitary-prophylactic work during 5 vears of the Soviet governement Public Health Protection] Gig. epidem., Moskva, 1930, 9: 3-12.—Bourdet, B. I. [Data for evaluation of the health movement, inaugu- rated by the government on 27. VI. 1936] Akush. gin., 1940, No. 6, 64-9.—Eruni, N. Le condizioni sanitarie della Russia. Igiene mod., 1922, 15: 129-32.—Bychkov, I. J. [Fines, im- posed by the governmental hygienic inspection] Gig. & zdorov., 1941, 6: 59-64.—Dichtiar, S. [Evaluation of public health organization in White Russia] Bieloruss. med. dumka, 1927, 3: 54-67.—Efimov, D. [The October Revolution and health preservation] Profil. med., Kharkov, 1927, 6: No. 12, 101; No. 7, 165.—Expenditure on public health in 1937 [Russia] J. Am. M. Ass., 1937, 108: 2239.—Filatov, V. P. [Results of 20 years' work of the Soviet Public Health] Sovet. med., 1938, No. 14-15, 21-8.—Frenkel, Z. G. [Plans and achieve- ments of radical sanitation and welfare in new capitals of the national republics of the USSR] Profil. med., Kharkov, 1927, 6: No. 4, 80-8.—Gorfin, D. V. [Soviet public health "care from the October revolution to the 17. Congress of the Bolshevik Party] Klin, med., Moskva, 1939, 17: No. 4, 15-25.------ [State of public health service in former Poland, western Ukraine and western White Russia] Gig. san., Moskva, 1939, 4: No. 11, 7-13.—Guest, L. H. Public health in Soviet Russia. Lancet, Lond., 1920, 2: 518; 566; 617; 661. Also Brit. M. J., 1923, 2: 677; 730; 779.------Russia in reconstruction. Lancet, Lond., 1931, 2: 1147.—Gurevich, Z. A. [Twenty-five years of Soviet pubhc health] Vrach. delo, 1938, 20: 633-40. ----— [Hygienic-epidemiological stations: base institute of State Hygienic Inspection] Gig. & zdorov., 1941, 6: 4-7.— Kagan, S. S. [Public health in the USSR on the eve of the 22d anniversary of the October socialistic revolution] Radi- anska med., 1939, 4: No. 8-9, 5-16. ------ [Public health service in Soviet Russia] Vrach. delo, 1941, 23: 35-46.— Kanin, A. [Organization of health service] Sovet. vrach. J., 1939, 43: 299-302.—Kazanskaia, V. [Results of the year's work of sanitary units in villages of White Russia] Bieloruss. med. dumka, 1925-26, 2: 12-20.—Kogan, E. M. [Medico- hygienic sciences and problems for the second 5 year plan in ---- Rochester, New York. Rochester, N. Y. Health Bureau. An- nual report. Rochester, 1868; 1877-78; 1883-84; 1888; 1893-1927. ---- Health bureau; monthly reports. 1887- 1894; 1914- HEALTH ORGANIZATION lNli HEALTH ORGANIZATION Soviet Russia! Sovet. vrach. gaz., 1932, 36: 613.—Kolesnikov, S. A. [The public health plan for 1941] Sovet. med., 1941, 5: 3-9.- Kuschnir, E. [Development of health-protection in Firstma\ district during the pa-t 10 years after the revolution] Profil. med.. Kharkov, 1927. 6: No. 10, 48-53.—Pietri, P. Mission sanitaire francaise en Kussie; notes et impressions de voyage. J. mid. Bordeaux, 1919, 49: 96; 113; 133.—[Plan (The) of state sanitary inspection bv the Public Health of Soviet Russia for 1939] Gig. san., Moskva, 1939, No. 2-3, 21-32. (Plans for health protection for 1937 in Soviet Russia] Sovet. vrach. J., 1937, 2: 1-12.—Polinrky, B. [Military sanitary propaganda in villages] Profil. med.. Kharkov, 1927, 6: No. 10, 166-8. Proppcr-tirashchenkov, N. I. [Twenty vears of Soviet public health] Klin, med., Moskva, 1937, 15: 1177-94. Also Sovet. med., 1938, No. 14-15, 3-7.------ [The problems of the public health service in 1939 in Soviet Russia] Gig. san., Moskva. 1939, 4: No. 5, 7-13.------ [Plan of work of the public health service of the USSR in the second half of 1939] Ibid., No. 7. 48-56. ------ [Problems of public health in the third 5 year plan] Sovet. med.. 1939, N'o. 8, 6-9.— Public health administration in Russia in 1917. Boston M. & S. .1., 1918, 179: 568-71. Also Science, 1918, n. ser., 47: 163.—Public health work in Russia. Queens Nurs. Mag., 1934. 27: 79-81.—Rosenman, L. A.. & Eiges, N. R. [Methods in the work of the brigade of the Public Health Service in the- legion of Ivanovsk] Vopr. materin., 1940, No. 11, 23- 6.- Russia [Establishment of a Principal Bureau of Imperial Health Preservation] Vest, obshtsh. hig. sudeb. & prakt. med.. IVtrogr., 1916, 52: off. pt, 119-57.—[Sanitary service statistics; the most important weapon of sanitary service] Gig. san., Moskva, 1940, 5: No. 4, 1.—Semashko, N. Die Gesundheitsverhaltnisse in Sowiet-Kussland. Deut. med. Wsrhi., 1921, 47: 720. - ■- Das Gesundheitswesen in Sowjct-Ru.-sland. Ibid., 1924, 50: 117; passim.- Smirnov. P. V., Galporin, E. A. [et al.] (Materials of the expedition of the People's commissariat of public health of the RSFSR to the Taimyr and Evenkian national districts in 1937] .1. mikrob.. Moskva, 1939, No. 7, 47-56.—Syssine, A. L'Institut d'etat d'hygiene municipale du commissariat du peuple pour la sant6 publique en RSFSR iMoscou) Bull. Off. in- ternat. hyg. pub., Par., 1935, 27: 1793 6. Tenenboem, N. [Twenty years of sanitan -cultural work in Soviet Russia] Yoen. san. delo, 193S. No. 2. 3-16.- Tkachev, T. J. [Reports in the system of state sanitary inspeeiion] dig. san.. Moskva, 1910, 5: No. 11. 4 9. Winslow. <'. E. A. Public health administra- tion in Russia in 1917. Pub. Health Rep., Wash., 1917, 32: 2191-219- Wolfson, I. A. [Historical review of public health in Russia during the first half of the 19. century] Sovet. vrach. gaz.. 1934, 38: 451-64- Zhbankov, I). N. [Principal Bureau of the National Preservation of the Public Health, and its significance for public autonomous bodies] Prakt. vrach, 1916. 15: 338; 352. ---- Sacramento, California. Sacramento, Calif. Health Department. Annual reports! Sacramento, 1862-63; 1880-81; 1894-97; 1920; 1927- ----Monthly bulletin. Sacramento, 1922- Monthlv statement of vital statistics. Sacramento, 1899 -1921. ---- St Christopher and Nevis, Leeward Islands. St Christopher & Xeyis. Chief Medical Officer. Annual medical and sanitary report. Basseterre, 1897- ---- St Etienne, France. Saixt-Etiexxe, France. Bureau d'hy- giene. Bulletin statistique. St Etienne, v 40 1924-28. ----St Louis. Missouri. St Louis, Mo. Division of Health. De- partment of Public Welfare. Annual report Jefferson City, 1.-48., 1867-1896; 62., 1929-30.' ---- St Lucia, Windward Islands. St Lucia. Medical & Sanitary Depart- ment. Annual report. Castries, 1899; 1914- ---- St Marylebone, England. St Marylebone, Eng. Medical Officer of Health. Report. St Marvlebone, 1856-1907- 1913- St Pancras, England. St Pancras, Eng. Medical Offkek of Health. Report. St Pancras, 1889 1910; 1913- ---- St Paul, Minnesota. Flint, E. M., & Aronovkt. C. Health con- ditions and health service in Saint Paul. 103p. 8? [St Paul] 1919. St Paul, Minn. Bureau of Health. An- nual report. St Paul, 1884- ---- Monthly bulletin. St Paul, v.l 3, 1912-14; v.6, 1917- ----Report to the Commissioner of education and Superintendent of schools. St Paul, 1937 39. Young, G. B. Public health administration in St Paul, Minn. Pub. Health Rep., Wash., 1917, 32: 41-71. ---- St Vincent, Windward Islands. St Vixcext. Chief Medical Officer. Annual medical and sanitary report. Kingstown, 1887- ---- Salem, Massachusetts. Salem, Mass. Board of Health. Annual report, Salem, 1883-85; 1887-90; 1892- ---- Salford, England. Salford, Eng. Medical Officer of Health. Annual report. Salford, 1875- Salford, Eng. Medical Officer of Health. School Medical Officer. Annual report. Salford, 1932; 1934-35; 1937-38. ---- Salt Lake City, Utah. Salt Lake City, Utah. Board of Health. Annual report. Salt Lake City, 1890-93; 1895-98; 1911-16; 1934. ---- Report (monthly) Salt Lake City, 1933-34. ---- Salvador. Miranda, J. B. Report. Repub., 1911, 5. Conf., 111. Tr. Internat. San. Conf. Am. ---- Samoan Islands, U. S. A. Samoa. Department of Public Health. Report of the health. Tutuila, 1929. Hunt, l>. Sanitation in American Samoa. TJ. S. Nav. M. Bull., 1923, 18: 438-48, pl. ---- San Antonio, Texas. Sax Antonio, Tex. Health Department. Annual report. San Antonio, 1886-92; 1897-98; 1901-2; 1905 6; 1909-10. Monthly vital statistics. San Antonio, 1900-31. ---- San Diego, California. San Diego, Calif. Health Department. Annual report. San Diego, v.l, 1888; 1910-16; 1922; 1924; 1926- - Monthly report. San Diego, 1897-1925. ---- San Francisco, California. Hiscock, I. V. An appraisal of the public health program, San Francisco, California, for the fiscal year 1929-30. 1 lop. 8? [San Franc, 1930] San Francisco, Calif. Department of H^oL!H- Annual report. San Franc, 1866-67; 1868-69; 1870-1903; 1906-17; 1924-25. ,«77 Monthly bulletin. San Franc, 1899- 1914. HEALTH ORGANIZATION 187 HEALTH ORGANIZATION --- San Jose, California. San Jose, Calif. Health Department. Annual report. San Jose, 1923- --- Santa Fe, Argentina. Sante Ft (Provixcia) Direccion general de higiene. Memoria . . . [Sante Fe] 1937. ---- Sao Paulo, Brazil. CortEz, A. *Centros de saude de Sao Paulo. 170p. 8? S. Paulo, 1926. Sao Paulo. Directoria do servico sani- tario. Annuario demographico. S. Paulo, 1901-28. ---- Boletim hebdomadario de estatistica demographico-sanitaria. S. Paulo, 1904-27. Ayrosa, M. Servico de saude; secciio de engenharia sani- taria. Arq. hig., S. Paulo, 1939, 4: No. 6, 174—Borges Vieira, F. Eschema da organizacao sanitaria do estado de Sao Paulo. Bol. Of. san. panamer., 1936, 15: 5-13.—Mileo, J. N. Organizacao do aparelhamento sanitario do estado de S. Paulo. Ibid., 1935, 14: 1035-9.------Os servicos de sAude publica na zona norte do estado de Sao Paulo. Arch. hyg., S. Paulo, 1937, 2: No. 3, 325-33, 2 pl.—Officio dirigido em 18 de marco de 1884, pelo Dr Marcos de Oliveira Arruda, inspector interino de hygiene ao Exm. Sr Dr Domingos Josi Freire, digno presidente da juncta de hygiene. Ibid., 505.— Paula Souza, G. H. de, & Borges Vieira, F. Centro de saude; eixo de organizacao sanitaria. Bol. Inst. hig. S. Paulo, 1936, No. 59, 1-60, 2 tab.—Servicos de saude do Estado em 1938; resumo do relatorio geral. Arq. hig., S. Paulo, 1939, 4: No. 6, 119-260, 10 pl. --- Saranac Lake, New York. Saranac Lake, N. Y. Board of Health. Bulletin. Saranac Lake, July, 1916. --- Health officer's annual report. 1916. --- Saskatchewan, Canada. Saskatchewan, Canada. Department of Public Health. Annual report and vital statistics report. Regina, 1910- Davison, R. O. The history of public health in Saskatche- wan. Canad. Pub. Health J., 1935, 26: 596-605.—Middleton, F. C. Review of public health administration in the province of Saskatchewan. Proc. Conf. Health Author. N. America, 1931, 46: 46-56.—Seymour, M. M. Public health work in Saskatchewan. Canad. M. Ass. J., 1925, 15: 271-8. ---Savannah, Georgia. Savannah, Ga. Departmext of Public Health. Annual reports. Savannah, 1882-83; 1912-15; 1917; 1923. --- Monthly health record. Savannah, v.7, 1930- ---Schenectady, New York. Schenectady, X. Y. Department of Health. Annual report. Schenectady, 0., 1887- Clark, W. M. The Schenectadv health center. Month. Bull. N. York State Dep. Health, 1919, n. ser., 14: 146. --- Scotland, Great Britain. Scotland. Department of Health. An- nual report. Edinb., 1.-7., 1919-25. --- Committee on Scottish health services; report. 404p. 241,em. Edinb., 1936. Health of Scotland; department's annual report. Brit. M. J., 1935, 1: 831—Scotland's health services. Ibid., 1941, 2: 251.—Scottish (The) health services; memorandum of evidence by the association's Scottish committee. Ibid., 1934, 2: (Suppl.) 1-16. ---- Scranton, Pennsylvania. Scranton, Pa. Department of Health. Annual report. Scranton, 1887-97; 1903-7; 1909-13; 1915-17; 1923-24. ---- Seattle, Washington. Seattle, Wash. Department of Health and Sanitation. Bulletin. Seattle, v.9-18, 1916-25. Report. Seattle, 1891; 1893; 1901- ----Seattle's health and sanitation. Seattle, v.18-24, 1925-31. ---- Seine (Dept.) France. Seine (Dept.) France. Conseil d'hygiene publique et de salubrite. Rapports gencraux des travaux. Par., 1862-1903. ----Rapports sur les travaux des commis- sions d'hygiene. Par., 1882-1903. Ichok, G. Le budget de la sant6 publique dans la Seine. Paris med., 1937, 106: annexe, 151-4.—Malespine, E. Or- ganisation des bureaux d'hvgiene dans le d6partement de la Seine. Ann. hyg., Par., 1938, n. ser., 16: 189-201. ---- Seine inferieur (Dept.) France. Seine-Inferieure. Conseil central d'hy- giene publique et de salubrity. Travaux. Rouen, 1832-1908. ---- Seine-et-Oise, France. Auscher, E. S. Rapport sur l'etat sanitaire du d£partement de Seine-et-Oise durant les ann6es 1919, 1920 et 1921. Rev. hyg., Par., 1924, 46: 701-20. ---- Seychelles Islands. Seychelles Colony. Medical Depart- ment. Annual report. Victoria, 1908- ---- Shanghai, China. Shanghai, China. Public Health De- partment. Report of the Commissioner. Shang- hai, 1898- Annual report of the public health department of the Shanghai municipal council, 1933. J. Trop. M. Hyg., Lond., 1935, 38: Suppl., 52.—Brongniart, M. Les services d'hygiene de Shanghai. Ann. hyg., Par., 1933, n. ser., 11: 106-9 — Jordan, J. H. Municipal health administration in the Inter- national Settlement, Shanghai. China M. J., 1929, 43: 338- 43. ---- Shenandoah, Pennsylvania. Shenandoah, Pa. Board of Health. An- nual report. Shenandoah, 2.-10., 1894-1903. ---- Siam. Siam. Department of Public Health. Report. Bangkok, 1922-23; 1925-26. Varavarn, S. Public health and medical service in Siam. 60p. 24^cm. Bangkok, 1930. Barnes, M. E. Public health developments in Siam. Nation's Health, Chic, 1923, 5: 675; 737. ---- Sierra Leone. Sierra Leone. Health Department. Med- ical and Sanitary Department. Annual re- port. Freetown, 1908- Bullctin. Freetown, 1922; 1924-26; 1930. ----Bulletin of infectious diseases. Free- town, 1934- ---- Sind, India. Review (A) of medical and public health reforms in Sind. Sind M. J., 1939, 12: 28-35. ---- Singapore, Straits Settlements. Singapore, Straits Settlement. Health Department. Annual report. Singapore, 1913- ---- Smyrna, Turkey. Bassi, G. Le condizioni sanitarie di Smyrne, Ann. med. nav., Roma, 1919, 2: 1063-6. HEALTH ORGANIZATION 1 SS HEALTH ORGANIZATION ---- Solomon Islands (British) Solomon Islands Protectorate. Medical Officer of Health. Annual medical and sani- tary report. Suva, Fiji, 1928- ---- Somerville, Massachusetts. Somerville, Mass. Board of Health. Annual report. Somerville, 1., 1878- ---- Sourabaya, Neth. East Indies. Annual report of the Public Health Service at Sourabaya 1917. Meded. Burgerl. geneesk. dienst Ned. Indie, 1920, 9: 3-77. ---- South Africa (Union) Reid, A. W. Sanitation and public health, with special reference to South Africa. 270p. 8? Cape Town [&c] 1923. I'xiox of South Africa. Department of Public Health. Annual report. Pretoria. 1920- ----Epidemic diseases (monthly) Pretoria, 1924-30. ----Weeklv bulletin of infectious diseases. Pretoria, 1924-' Health in 1940. Med. Off., Lond., 1940, 63: 171.— HiUKin.s, T. S. Health problems in the Union of South Africa. Ibid., 1930, 55: 15 — Laidler, P. W. The relationship of the native to South Africa's health. S. Afr. M. J., 1932, 6: 617- 28.-- McNeil, K. B. A. Are we making the best of our future citizens in South Africa from the time of conception. Ibid., 1935, 9: 741-3. Our land: is our population satisfactory? Ibid., 701-4. ---- South Australia. Australia (South) Department of Public Health. Public health notes. Adelaide, No. 18, 1936. . Wilson, C. E. C. Some aspects of public hygiene and health administration in South Australia. Med. J. Australia, 1931, 2: 469-77. ---- South Bend, Indiana. Fox, C. Public health administration in South Bend, Indiana. Pub. Health Rep., Wash., 1917, 32: 776-805. ---- South Carolina, U. S. A. South Carolina. State Board of Health. Annual report, Columbia, 1.-4., 1880-83; 7.-11., 1886-90; 13.-19., 1892-98; 21.-28., .1900-7; 32., 1911- Hayne, J. A. Advances in public health work in South Carolina during the past year. South. M. J., 1917, 10: 406-8. ---- South Dakota, I. S. A. South Dakota. State Board of Health Biennial report, Pierre. 1905-10; 1912-20; 1922- South Dakota. State Board of Health. Division' of Vital Statistics. Annual report. Pierre, 1., 1905-1 S; 1920; 1924-25; 1933. Monthly bulletin. Pierre, v.3-4, 1915- 16; v.l 4, n. ser., 1924-27. ---- Southport, England. Southport, Exg. Medical Officer of Health. Annual report of the health and sanitary condition. Southport, 1912-37. Southport, Exg. Medical Officer of Health. School Medical Officer. Annual report. Southport, 1909; 1912-37. ---- Spain. Marraro, H. R. La sanidad publica en Espagna. 14 1. 4? X. Y.. 1923. Selig.maxx, A. *Die Gesundheitsverhaltnis.se in Spanien. 23p. 8? Lpz., 1925. Spaix. Ixspecciox general de sanidad. Boletin mensual de estadistica demografio- sanitaria. Madrid, 1910. Spain. Ministerio de la gobernaci6n. La reorganizaci6n sanitaria en Espafia. 206p. 4° Madrid, 1909. Carlan. D. Comentarios a una crftica sanitaria. Siglo mid., 1936, 97: 69.—Emolumentos sanitarios; oficial; Minis- terio de la gobernaci6n. Rev. med. contemp., Madr., 1908, 30: 38; 52.—Fern&ndez de las Heras, B. Iiisuficiencia del sistema actual de auxilios a los pueblos peciuefios para obras de saneamiento. Actas Congr. nac. san., Madr. (1934) 1935, 1. Congr., 3: 173-81.—Fern&ndez Horques, M. Bases para la constituci6n de una mancomunidad, oficial o libre, de institutos provinciales de higiene. Ibid., 423-9.—G6ngora Visconti, J. Posibilidades econ6micas de los ayuntamientos espafioles para emprender costosas instalaciones de ingenierie sanitaria, dentro del actual r6gimen tributario. Ibid., 448-55.— Martinez Vargas. El Ministerio de sanidad en Espafia. Med. ninos, 1921, 22: 133; 161; 193.—Mission sanitaire en Espagne; 28 dicembre 1936—15 Janvier 1937; rapport. Arch. Inst. Pasteur Tunis, 1937, 26: 170-91.—Munoz Antunano, L. Saneamiento i higienizaci6n de Espafia. Siglo mid., 1921, 68: 1176; passim.—Salazar, M. M. Comentarios al presupuesto de sanidad. Rev. san. mil., Madr., 1920, 3. ser., 10: 189; 219; 253.—Sanidad (La) en el parlamento; una gran Jornada para las clases sanitarias. Siglo mid., 1935, 95: 378-82. ---- Spain, colonial. Mestre Peon, F., Zarco Bohorques, P., & Najera Angulo, L. Necesidad de incorporar a la sanidad nacional los servicios sanitarios de la zona del protectorado de Marruecos y de las colonias del Africa occidental, y normas que deber&n regular la citada incorporaci6n. Actas Congr. nac. san., Madr. (1934) 1935, 1. Congr., 1: 145-67. ---- Spartanburg County, South Carolina. Spartanburg. County Department op Health. Annual report. Spartanburg, v.5, 1930- ---- Spokane, Washington. Spokane, Wash. Department of Health and Sanitation. Annual report. Spokane, 3., 1894/95- ---Monthly report. Spokane, 1917-18. ---- Springfield, Massachusetts. Springfield, Mass. Board of Health. Annual report. Springf., 1891-1930; 1935- ---- Springfield, Ohio. Fox, C. Public health administration in Springfield, Ohio. Pub. Health Rep., Wash., 1917, 32: 1255-78. ---- Staffordshire County, England. Staffordshire County, Eng. Medical Officer of Health. Annual report. Stafford, 1899- ---- Stockholm, Sweden. Stockholm, Sweden. Stads Statistiska Kontor. Berattelse fran Stockholms stads halsovardsnamnd jamte oversikt av stadens sanitara statistik. Stockholm, 1911- ---- Stoke Newington, England. Stoke Newington, Eng. Medical Officer of Health. Report on the health of the metro- politan borough. Stoke Newington, 1895-1934. ---- Stoke-on-Trent,England. Stoke-on-Trent, Eng. Public Health Department. Annual report. Stoke-on-Trent, 1912- ---- Straits Settlements. International Health Board of Rocke- feller Foundation. Final report on the survey of hookworm infection, general sanitary condi- tions and organized health (Barnes, M. E., & Russell, P. F.) 80p. 8? Singapore, 1925. Straits Settlements. Medical Depart- ment. Annual report. Singapore, 1895- HEALTH ORGANIZATION 189 HEALTH ORGANIZATION SeiflTert, G. Das Gesundheitswesen im fernen Osten (Straits Settlements und Malaia) Miinch. med. Wschr., 1935, 82: 587-91. ---- Strassburg, Germany. Strasbourg, France. Office municipal d'hygiene. Rapport. Strasb., 1910-37. --- Suceava, Rumania. Gomoiu, V., & Platareanu, V. [Development of sanitation in the ancient city of Suceava] Spitalul, 1941, 61: 83-7. ---- Sudan (Anglo-Egyptian) Sudan. Medical Service. Report on medical and health work. Khartoum, 1921- Health (The) services of the Sudan. Med. Off., Lond., 1940, 63: 29. ---- Sudan (French) Suldey. Le Service de sant6 au Soudan francais. Ann. med. pharm. col., Par., 1926, 24: 532-55. ---- Sumsky, Russia. Gernstein, L. [Results of 3 years work by Suma sanitary organization (1924-26)] Profil. med., Kharkov, 1927, 6: No. 8-9, 180-92. --- Suriname. See in this list Netherlands West Indies. --- Surrey County, England. Surrey County, Eng. Medical Officer of Health and School Medical Officer. An- nual report. Surrey, 1897; 1911-34. --- Swaziland, South Africa. Swaziland. Medical Officer. Annual medical and sanitary report. Mbabane, 1917; 1922- --- Sweden. Post, R. A. von [A modern sanitary system and sanitary work in Eskilstuna] 42p. 12? Stockh., 1904. Sweden. Kungl. Medicinalstyrelsen. All- man halso- och sjukvard. Stockholm, 1908- --- Sinnessjukvarden i riket. Stockholm, 1911- Wawrinsky, R. A. DeVeloppement historique et itat actuel du service sanitaire civil en Suede. Rev. internat. Croix-Rouge, 1920, 2: 807-23. --- Switzerland. Switzerland. Eidgenossisches Gesund- heitsamt. Bulletin. Bern, v.l, 1918- --- Bulletin; Beilage. Bern, 1919- --- Mitteilungen aus dem Gebiete der Le- bensmitteluntersuchung und Hygiene. Bern, v.l, 1910- Gengou, O. Note sur 1'organisation sanitaire en Suisse. Schweiz. med. Wschr., 1925, 55: 212-8. --- Syracuse, New York. Syracuse, N. Y. Board of Health. Annual report. Syracuse, 1884-1909; 1911-12; 1930; 1933. ---- Monthly bulletin. Syracuse, v. 1-2, 1914-15. ---- Weekly bulletin. Syracuse, v. 1-4, 1922-25. --- Syria. Beauge, C. En Syrie et au Liban; l'assistance m£dicale en 1922. Arch. med. chir. province, 1924, 14: 284-8.—Emily, J. La protection de la sante publique en Syrie sous le mandat francais. Presse med., 1930, 38: 1005-7. --- Tacoma, Washington. Tacoma, Wash. Health Department. Mu- nicipal bulletin. Tacoma, 1911-20: 1923. i o^7~,n3atement of vital statistics. Tacoma, loy8—1908. ---- Tanganyika Territory. Tanganyika Territory. Medical and Sani- tary Services. Annual medical and sanitary report. Dar es Salaam, 1918- ---- Tasmania, Australia. Tasmania. Department of Public Health. Annual report. Hobart, 1904- ---- Taunton, Massachusetts. Taunton, Mass. Board of Health. An- nual report. Taunton, 2.-[34.] 1884-1916. --- Tennessee, U. S. A. Tennessee. Department of Public Health. Annual bulletin of vital statistics. Nashville, 1927- ---- Annual [and biennial] report. Nashville, 1877-84; 1909-10; 1926- ---- Health briefs. Nashville, v. 1-13, 1927- 36. Bishop, E. L. A review of public health administration in Tennessee. Proc. Conf. Health Author. N. America, 1931, 46: 57-67.------A review of the work of the past year, plans and policies for the next 2 vears. Rep. Conf. Tennessee Health Work., 1932, 5: 88-99.—History and organization of the state department of health [Tennessee] Health Briefs, Nashville, 1936, 13: No. 1, 1-4; passim. ---- Texas, U. S. A. Jameson, R. M. A model health code for Texas cities. 98p. 8? [Austin, Tex.] 1915. Texas. State Department of Health. Annual and biennial report. Austin, 1891-92; 1899-1902; 1905-18; 1920-24; 1927- ---- Bulletin. Austin, v.l, 1934- ---- Monthly and quarterly bulletin. Austin, v.1-9,1907-15; 1922-23. ---— Texas health magazine. Austin, v.l, Nos 1-3, 1919-20. ---- Weekly news letter. Austin, 1925-28. Brown, J. W. Local health activities in Texas. Southwest. M., .1935, 19: 8-11.—Cox, G. W. Plans for pubhc health in Texas. Texas J. M., 1937-38, 33: 232-5.—Goddard, C. W. The needs of the State Health Department. Ibid., 1919-20, 15: 49-52.—Prothro, E. W. The need for organized public health work in Texas. Ibid., 1939-40, 35: 854-8. ---- Thiiringen, Germany. Kiihn. Die Stellung der thiiringischen Kreisarzte in der neuen Landesverwaltungsordnung fiir Thiiringen. Zschr. Medbeamte, 1926, 39: 607-11. ---- Titusville, Pennsylvania. Titusville, Pa. Board of Health. Annual report. Titusville, 1896-1904; 1906-10. ---- Toledo, Ohio. Fox, C. Public health administration in Toledo. 64p. 8? Wash., 1915. Toledo, Ohio. Board of Health. Annual report. Toledo, 1867-1924; 1926-28; 1937-39. ---- Toledo sanitary journal (monthly) Toledo, v.3, 1915. Iford, D. W. .Reorganization of Toledo Health Depart- ment, replacing sanitary police with public health nurses. OhioM. J., 1915, 11:774. ---- Torino, Italy. Torino, Italy. ■ Servizi d'igiene e di sanita. Bollettino statistico. Tor., 1909; 1911-13; 1915-16. ---- Estratti dall'annuario del municipio. Tor. (1915-24) 1923-28. ---- Toronto, Ontario. Toronto. City Engineer. Annual report. Toronto, 1890-1902. HEALTH ORGANIZATION 190 HEALTH ORGANIZATION Toronto. Canada. Department of Public Health. Monthlv report. Toronto, 1913-20; 1925- --- Statistical review. Toronto, 1934- Hastings, C. J. An outline of public health administration in Toronto, Canada. Med. Press & Circ, Lond., 1926, n. ser., 122: 128-32. ---- Torquay, England. Torquay, Eng. Medical Officer of Health. Annual report together with a sum- mary of reports of the sanitary inspectors and meteorological observer. Torquay, 1882-1901; 1913- ---- Trinidad, West Indies. Trinidad. Surgeon-General. Administra- tion report, Trinidad, 1908-33; 1935- Administration report of the surgeon-general for the year 1935 (Trinidad and Tobago) J. Trop. M. Hyg., Lond., 1937, 40: No. 24, Suppl., 94-6.—Laurence, S. M. Forty years of progress in public health administration in the West Indies, and Trinidad in particular. Canad. M. Ass. J., 1931, 24: 562-6. ---- Troy, New York. Troy, N. Y. Department of Public Health. Annual report. Troy, 1S54-55; 1866-67; 1932- 34. — Monthly bulletin. Troy, 1928-32. — Monthly report. Tn>y, 1906-27. ---- Tula, Russia. Bielousov, P. P. [Sanitary organization and its problems in Tula] Tr. Sezda Russk. Vrach. Pirogov (1891) 1892, 4. Congr., 265-74. ---- Turkey. Boukowski, C. Sur les mesures d'hygidne projetSes en Turquie. J. chim. mid.. Par., 1869, 5. sir., 5: 42-4.—Ferriere, F. Secours aux populations turques de la Thrace et aux populations chie4ieiuies de l'Anatolie. Rev. internat. Croix Rouge, 1922. 4: 557-63.—Goldberg, G. Forderung des tiirkisclien (Jesundheitswesens. Gesundh. Ingenieur, 1916, 39: 517.—Kessler, O. Deutsche sanitiire Arbeit in der Tiirkei. Deut. med. Wschr.. 1918, 44: 1334.—McKinlay, R. A brief history of the Interallied Sanitary Commissions in Turkey, abstracted from the annual report of the Sanitary Com- missioner, Constantinople, for the vear 1922. J. R. Army M. Corps, 1924, 42: 359-73.—Niyazi, Y. [Health service] Askeri sihhiye mecmuaM, 1937, 66: 83-91.—Turkey. Law No. 3017 of the 18. June, 1936, regarding the organisation of the ministry of hygiene and social assistance. Bull. Hyg., Lond., 1937, 12: 546." ---- Tyosen, Japan. Sanitary conditions of Chosen (Korea) League of Nations Health Org. Japan, Geneve, 1925, 261-9. ---- Uganda Protectorate. Uganda. Medical Department. Annual report. Entebbe, 1912- Hooper, R. C D., & Loewenthal, L. J. A. A survey of health work in Teso, Uganda. Ann. Trop. M. Parasit., Liverp., 1936, 30: 17-32, 1 pl. ---- Ukrainia. Efimov, D. J. [New step in development of health protec- tion in Ukrainia] Profil. med., Kharkov, 1927, 6: No. 2, 114-23; No. 10, 1-14.—Gomelsky, G. L. [Principles in the development of public health during the 3d 5-year plan in UkrainiaJ Radianska med., 1939, 4: No. 8-9, 73-8!—Kholodny. La situation sanitaire de I'Ukraine. Rev. internat. Croix Rouge, 1922, 4: 284-90. Also Deut. med. Wschr., 1925, 51: 1451.—Lifschitz, J. Efhuts to revise Ukrainian health protec- tion and sanitary work. Profil. med., Kharkov, 1927, 6: No. 7, 155-64.- Marzeiev, A. [Sanitary work in Ukrania before the October revolution and for 10 vears after] Ibid No. 10, 15-26; 1928, 7: 13 -20.- Slinko, A. [Survey of activity of the Soviet national committee of public health for July and August 1927] roid., No. 8-9, 102-7. ---- United States. See also in this list the names of States, cities and counties. Canalis, P. Appunti di viaggio di un lgieiusta negli Stati Uniti d'America. 20p. 8? Genovn, 1929. Chapin, C. V. Municipal sanitation in the United States. 970p. 8? Providence, 1901. DeKruif, P. H., & DeKruif, P. Why keep them alive? 293p. 8? N. Y, [1936] Ferrell, J. A., & Mead, P. A. History of county health organizations in the United States 1908-33. 469p. 8? Wash., 1936. Leigh, Pi. I). Federal health administration in the United States. 687p. 8? N. Y. [1927] Lookstein, A. *Administration de l'hygiene aux Etats-IJnis. 39p. 8° Par., 1936. Smillie, W.'G. Public health administration in the United States. 458p. 8? N. Y., 1935. United States. Interdepartmental Com- mittee to Coordinate Health and Welfare Activities. Toward better national health. 30p. 8? Wash., 1939. United States. Public Health Service. Annual report of the Surgeon General. Wash., 1872- ---- Bulletin. Wash., No. 3-239, 1S99 1938; No. 250, 1940- ----The health officer. Wash., v.l, 1936- Wallace, J. The state health departments of Massachusetts, Michigan, and Ohio, with a summary of activities and accomplishments, 1927-28. 192p. 8? N. Y., 1930. Annual report of public health service. J. Am. M. Ass., 1939, 112: 457.—Armstrong, D. B., & Tobey, J. A. The National Health Council. Boston M. & S. J., 1922, 186: 677-80.—Bancroft, C. P. The public health movement as affected by the world war. Tr. N. Hampshire M. Soc, 1919, 128: 52-65.—Baumgartner, L. Recent developments in pubhc health in U. S. A. Med. Woman J., 1939, 46: 21-4.— Bernard, L. L'hygiSne et la sant6 publique aux Etats-Unis d'AmSrique. Bull. Acad, mid., Par., 1922, 3. ser., 87: 378- 92.—Bracken, H. M. The development of public health ac- tivities in the United States. Proc. Conf. Health Author. N. America, 1934, 49: 15-31.—Capone-Brega, P. L'organiz- zazione sanitaria delle conte degli Stati Uniti. Ann. igiene, 1933, 43: 883-7.—Coffey, E. R. Keeping America healthy. Minnesota M., 1939, 22: 677-81.------Public health ex- pands its facilities under title VI, Federal Social Security Act. Am. J. Pub. Health, 1941, 31: 297-304.—Cox, G. W. Our public health status. Texas J. M., 1941-42, 37: 53-7 — Cumming, H. S. The National Health Council. Pub. Health Rep., Wash., 1921, 36: 2106-9.------Public health prob- lems of special interest to the South. South. M. J., 1930, 23: 15-8. ------ La sanidad en los Estados Unidos. Bol. Of. san. panamer., 1936, 15: 205-9. ------ Organizacion de higiene; encuesta sobre la obra nacional de higiene en los Esta- dos Unidos. Med. ibera, 1936, 30: pt 1, 313.------Lloyd, B. J., & Emerson, K. La sanidad en los Estados Unidos. Actas Conf. san. panamer., 1934, 459-75.—Dalla Valle, J. M. Census of public health personnel and facilities; health agencies. Tr. Conf. State Terr. Health Off., 1940, Spec, 159-64 — Draper, W. F. A national health program. N. England J. M., 1939, 220: 43-7.—Emerson, H. The national health program. N. York State J. M., 1939, 39: 990-3.—Facts about public health in the United States. Colorado M., 1934, 31: 315.—Ferrell, J. A. America's contributions and problems in pubhc health. Diplomate, 1934, 6: 35-44.—Fishbein, M. The national health program and American medicine. Dela- ware M. J., 1939, 11: 17-28.—Ford, W. W. The present status and the future of hygiene or public health in America. Science, 1915, n. ser., 42: 1-13. Also Tr. Ass. Am. Physicians, 1915, 30: 353-74.—Future (The) of public health in the United States and the education of sanitarians. Pub. Health Bull., Wash., 1922, No. 126, 1-159.—Golden, W. W. Our public health situation. J. Alumni Ass. Coll. Physicians, Bait., 1915, 18: 1-10.—Gray, H. F. Public health in America. Science, 1915, 42: 243-5.—Health (The 1934) conservation contests. Am. J. Pub. Health, 1935, 25: 633-5.- Hernando, E. Como se entiende la sanitaci6n en los Estados Unidos de la America del Norte. Rev. filip. med. farm., 1924, 15: 2-11, 2 pl.— Hiscock, I. V. Rehabilitation of health work in the United States. Yale J. Biol., 1934, 6: 609-18.— Horwood, M. P. An evaluation of the factors responsible for public health in ogress in the United States. Science, 1939, 89: 517-26.— Is there a doctor in the bill? Am. J. Pub. Health, 1941, 31: 369.—Jorstad, L. H. The relationship of the Women's field army to the state and national health departments. J. Missouri M. Ass., 1941, 38: 131.—Kraus, R. Eindrucke und Betrach- tungen iiber hygienische Verhaltnisse, mikrobiologische For- schung und Epidemiologie in den Voreinigten Staaten von Nord- amerika. Deut. med. Wschr., 1931, 57: 1676; 1753- 1827.— HEALTH ORGANIZATION Lamoureux, V. B. Faits nouveaux au sujet de l'organisation et de la legislation sanitaires aux Etats-Unis. Bull. Off. internat. hyg. pub., Par., 1938, 30: 1947-55.—Leach, C. N. Progress of health work in the Mississippi area. J. Am. M. Ass., 1928. 91: 1595-9.—Leathers, W. S. Public health activ- ities' in the southern states, with suggestions for increased efficiency. South. M. J., 1917, 10: 213-8— McCormack, A. T. The National health program. J. S. Carolina M. Ass., 1939, 35: 269-75.—McCoy, G. W. Die Organisation des Gesund- heitswesens in den Vereinigten Staaten. Seuchenbekampfung, Wien 1928, 5: 1-6.—McCullough, J. W. S. A decade of public health progress. Pub. Health J., Toronto, 1920, 11: 293-300.— McLaughlin, A. C, Chamberlain, W. P. [et al.] The relation of State and local boards of health to general preparedness. Am. J. Pub. Health., 1917, 7: 591-605.—McLaughlin, A. J. The future of public health work in the United States. Com- monhealth, Bost., 1919, 6: 317-23.—Magiera, E. A. Our public health program. Mississippi Doctor, 1938-39, 16: No. 11, 17-21.—March, L. L'organisation, de l'hygiene publique aux Etats-Unis. Paris med., 1922, 45: 452-8.— Miller, J. N. America's sanitary police. Hygiea, Chic, 1941, 19: 369-71.—National (A) health program, a summary. J. Am. M. Ass., 1938, 111: 432-4.— National (A) health program and some proposals toward its design (Special report, Inter- departmental Comm. Coordinate Health, etc.) Ibid., 110: 656-65.—National health program. In Or^. Payment M. Serv. (Am. M. Ass.) Chic, 1939, 21-7.—New Surgeon General plans vigorous health program. Science News Lett., 1936, 29: 212.—Nichols, S. Report of the sub-committee on public health. J. M. Soc. N. Jersey, 1937, 34: 246; 1939, 36: 669-73 — Odum, H. W. The south as testing ground for the regional approach to public health. Fed. Bull., Chic, 1939, 25: 325-32. Also J. Am. M. Ass., 1939, 112: 1097.—Osborn, S. H. Report of Federal relations committee. Proc. Conf. Health Author. N America, 1938, 53: 58.—Our public health service. Am J. Pub. Health, 1939, 29: 1044-6.—Parran, T. Los Grandes problemas sanitarios en Estados Unidos. Bol. Of. san. pan- amer., 1936, 15: 621. ------ La sanidad en los Estados Unidos. Ibid., 1937, 16: 203-7. ------ The health of the nation. Am. J. Pub. Health, 1938, 28: 1376-80.------ El servicio de sanidad pubhca y la ley del seguro social de Estados Unidos. Bol. Of. san. panamer., 1938, 17: 1-7. ----- Future of public health in the United States. J. Ass. Am. M. Coll., 1939, 14: 9-15.—Pettengill, S. B. The National health program. Illinois M. J., 1940, 78: 13-6.—Picken, R. M. F. Public health in the United States of America; the public health system. Brit. M. J., 1936, 2: 631-3. ------ Public health in the United States of America; modern services. Ibid., 719.—Pohlen, K. Schatzungen iiber den Aufwand fur die Gesundheitspflege der Vereinigten Staaten von Amerika. Reichsgesundhbl., 1934, 9: 380.—Pomeroy, J. L. Western public health problems. Am. J. Pub. Health, 1934, 24: 1234- 9.—President's message on the National health program. J. Am. M. Ass., 1939, 112: 333.—Public health in North Amer- ica. Med. Off., Lond., 1940, 63: 181.—Public health work in the United States. Q. Bull. Health Org. League of Nat., 1936, 5: 785-823.—Report of the Chairman of the executive board to the Governing council. Am. J. Pub. Health, 1940, 30: 1461-5.—Rivera Aponte, P. Breves observaciones rela- cionadas con salud pliblica durante mi reciente visita por los estados de Ohio y New York. Bol. As. mid. Puerto Rico, 1933, 25: 578-80.—Rucker, W. C. Interstate sanitary relations. J. Sociol. Med., Easton, 1917, 18: 23-31. Also Pub. Health Rep., Wash., 1917, 32: 198-202.—Rueck, G. A. The health program of the United States. Med. Rev. of Rev., 1919, 25: 711-5.—Schneider, F., jr. A survey of the activities of muni- cipal health departments in the United States. Am. J. Pub. Health, 1916, 6: 1-17.—Sedgwick, W. T. American achieve- ments and American failures in public health work. Ibid. 1915, 5: 1103-14. Also Science, 1915, n. ser., 42: 361-5.— Sharp, W. K., jr. Public health goals in the Umted States. Texas J. M., 1939-40, 35: 859-62.—Shryock. R. H. The origins and significance of the public health movement in the United States. Ann.M. Hist., 1929, n. ser., 1:645-65. Alsorepr. -----The early American public health movement. Am. J. Pub. Health, 1937, 27: 965-71.—Skundina, S. I. [Public health service in the United States of America] <"Ug. san., Moskva, 1939, 4: No. 10, 31-6.—Smillie, W. G. The future of public health administration in the United States. Illinois Health Mess., 1935, 7: 19-22.—Smith, S. Development of American public health endeavor. Am. J. Pub. Health, 1915, 5: 1115-9. -----■ Scientific sanitation in the conservation of the public health, 1866-1920. Good Health; Battle Creek, 1921, 56: 243-5.—Statement of Sir Arthur Newsholme [endorsing the public health program in the United States] Boston M. & S. J., 1919, 180: 619-21.—Underwood, F. J. Looking to a greater public health program. Mississippi Doctor, 1937-38, 15: No 10 42 —Van Etten, N. B. Better health for America. Diplomate,' 1940, 12: 207-13.—Varied (The) health problems of our many states. Pub. Health Nurse, 1919, 11: 509-15.— Vasconcellos, A. H. de. Organizacao dos servicos de saude publica nos Estados Unidos da America. Bol. san., Rio, 1924, 3: 5-28, 4 pl.—Weyrauch, R. Aus der nordamen- kanischen Gesundheitstechnik. Gesundh. Ingenieur, 1922, 45: 505.—Williams, E. G. Some remarks on the present status of public health work. Proc. Conf. State Prov. Bd Health N. America, 1916, 31: 5-12.—Wolman, A. The National health program; how far? how fast? Am. J. Pub. Health, 1939, 29: 628-32. HEALTH ORGANIZATION ---- Uralsk, Russia. Nikolaenko, I. I. [Sanitation of the city of Uralskl Gig & zdorov., 1941, 6: 74-9. ---- Uruguay. Uruguay. Consejo de salud pu/blica. Boletin. Montev., v.l 3, 1932-34. Uruguay. Consejo nacional de higiene. Boletin. Montev., 1916-31. Uruguay. Ministerio de Salud Publica. Evolucion de la sanidad en el Uruguay, anos 1927-1934. 96p. 8? Montev., 1934. Brusco, L. D. Convenciones y acuerdos sanitarios del Uruguay. Bol. Cons. nac. hig., Montev., 1918, 13: 681-702.— Etchepare, J. Iniciativas sanitarias, proyectadas o realizadas por el Consejo Nacional de Higiene; anos 1910-18. Ibid., 1919, 14: 255-301. ------ Origenes, organizaci6n actual y servicios sanitarios del Consejo nacional de higiene del Uruguay. Bol. Of. san. panamer., 1927, 6: 73-107.—Gortari, M. Orien- tacion higienica de los centros departamentales de salud publica. Bol. Soc. med. quir. centr., Montev., 1939, 6: No. 26-27, 96-9.—Information del ministerio de Salud Pliblica del Uruguay, relativa a las resoluciones de la IX conferencia sani- taria panamericana, que exigen accion subsiguente de la Oficina sanitaria panamericana y de los gobiernos signatarios. Actas Conf. panamer. dir. nac. san., Wash., 1936, 3. Congr., 43-50.— Ramos, Nunez [et al.] Organizaci6n sanitaria. Ibid., 52-75. ---- Utah, U. S. A. Utah. State Board of Health. Biennial report. Salt Lake City, 1907-14. Monthly bulletin. Salt Lake City. 1904-15. ----Quarterly bulletin. Salt Lake City, v.1-2, 1916-17. ---- Utica, New York. Utica. Board of Health. Annual report. Utica, 1877-98. ---- Vancouver, British Columbia. Vancouver, B. C. Board of Health. Annual report. Vancouver, 1912- --- Monthly report. Vancouver, 1916- Breeze, E. G. The Metropolitan health service of Greater Vancouver. Canad. Nurse, 1938, 34: 233-8. ---- Vanves, France. Picot, H. *Organisation et fonctionnement des services sanitaires de la ville de Vanves en matieres de defense passive [Paris] 16p. 25cm. Vanves, 1939. ---- Vasco-Navarra, Spain. Murillo, F. Organizaci6n y reforma de la sanidad en la region Vasco-Navarra. Med. ibera, 1920, 12: 389-91. ---- Vaud, Switzerland. Vaud (Canton) Switzerland. Service sani- taire. Rapport. Lausanne, 1892-1902. ---- Venezuela. Venezuela. Direccion de sanidad na- cional. Anales. Caracas, v. 1-3, 1919-22. ---- Informe. Caracas, 1917; 1919-31. Venezuela. Ministerio de sanidad y asistencia social. Almanaque sanitario. Cara- cas, 1940- ---- Economia social. 46p. 27%cm. Cara- cas, 1939. ----Memoria. Caracas, 1939- Casas Briceno, J. M. L'organizzazione della sanity pub- blica nei Venezuela. Atti Congr. internaz. teen, san., 1931, 2. Congr., 3: 273-82.—Chacin Itriago, L. G. Organizacion de la higiene pliblica en Venezuela. Bol. Of. san. panamer., 1927, 6: 29-48, port.—Como (De) verificar el Informe sobre condiciones sanitarias de una poblacion. Tijeret. malaria, Caracas, 1939, 2: 25-30.—Diez del Ciervo, C. Organizacion sanitaria y presupuestos de sanidad. Actas Conf. san. pan- amer., 1934, 129-78. HEALTH ORGANIZATION 1< )2 HEALTH ORGANIZATION --- Veracruz, Mexico. Veracruz, Mex. Department of Public Health. Report. Veracruz, June-Oct., 1914. Hernandez Mejia, A. Organizaci6n sanitaria del Estado de Veracruz, por el sistema de cooperaci6n. Tr. Panamer. M. Congr. (1931) 1933, 3. Congr., 443-52. --- Vermont, U. S. A. Vermont. State Board of Health. Bi- ennial report. Burlington, 1., 1897- ----Bulletin. Burlington, 1901-4; 1910; 1914-22. ---- Victoria, Australia. Victoria. Department of Public Health. Commission of Public Health. Health bulle- tin. Melbourne, v.l, 1925- ---- Report of the departmental medical committee. Victoria, Dec, 1915. Health administration in Victoria, 1834-1934. Health Bull., Melb., 1935, 1180-94. ---- Vinnitza, Russia. Merkov. A. Health protection in Vinnitza district. Profil. med., Kharkov, 1927, 6: No. 7, 196-9. ---- Virginia, U. S. A. Virginia. State Department of Health. Annual report. Richmond, 1.-3., 1872-74; 1910- ---- Bulletin. Richmond, v.8-12, 1903-8. ---Health bulletin. Richmond, v.l, 1936- —— Virginia health bulletin. Richmond, v.l, 1908- Williams, E. G. Work of the State Board of Health. Virginia M. Month., 1922-23, 49: 113-20. ---- Virgin Islands, U. S. A. Mink, O. J. The Medical Department in the Virgin Islands. Tr. Am. Soc. Trop. M., 1921, 17: 59-62. --- Waltham, Massachusetts. Waltham, Mass. Board of Health. An- nual report. Waltham, 1.-4., 1885-88; 6.-34., 1890-1918. ---- Wandsworth, England. Wandsworth, Eng. Medical Officer of Health. Annual report on the health and sani- tary conditions. Wandsworth, 1856-91; 1893; 1895-99; 1909- --- Washington (District of Columbia) District of Columbia. Health Depart- ment. Annual reports of the health officer. Wash., 1849-51; 1854; 1859-60; 1872- ---- Food inspection service, milk reports. Wash., 1921-39. ---- Health in the Capital City (weekly) Wash., v.1-3, 1939-41. ---- Weeklv statistical statement. Wash., 1874-1925. United States. Public Health Service [et al.] Report of a survey of the Health de- partment and other health agencies in the Dis- trict of Columbia made in 1937-38. 400p. 23cm. Wash., 1939. Hall, H. R. The Washington suburban sanitary district. Proc. Maryland Delaware Water & Sewer Ass., 1934, 8: 38-^4— Ruhland. G. C. The Health Department of the District of Columbia. Proc. Conf. Health Author. X. America 1940, 55. meet., 18.—Wiley, H. W. Support of the health office. Washington M. Ann., 1916, 15: 124-7. ---- Washington, U. S. A. Fox, C. Public health administration in the state of Washington, p.371-472. 8? Wash., 1915. Washington. State Dkpartment of Health. Annual and biennial report. Seattle, 1893-96; 1903-24; 1933-36. ---- Monthly bulletin. Seattle, v.2 5, 1912-15. ---- Watertown, Massachusetts Watertown, Mass. Board of Health. Annual report. Watertown, 1895-1921. --- Western Australia. Western Australia. Public Health De- partment. Report. Perth, 1909-10; 1912- --- Westfield, Massachusetts. Westfield, Mass. Board of Health. An- nual report. Westfield, 1897- ---- Westminster, England. Westminster, Eng. Medical Officer of Health. Report. Westminster, 1872; 1896; 1910- ---- West Virginia, U. S. A. West Virginia. State Department of Health. Annual and biennial report. Charles- ton, 1., 1881-1924. ---- Quarterly bulletin. Charleston, v.1-20, 1914-33. Clark, T. PubUc health administration in West Virginia; a study of the health laws and public health administration of the State of West Virginia. Pub. Health Rep., Wash., 1915, 30: 207-56. --- Wheeling, West Virginia. Wheeling, W. Va. Health Department. Annual health report Wheeling, 1907-9; 1911-13. --- White Plains, New York. Westchester's health. White Plains, N, Y., v.l, 1930- White Plains, N. York. Board of Health. Annual report. White Plains, 1926-29. History of the White Plains Department of Health. West- chester Health, 1930-31, 1: No. 11, 1. --- Wigan, England. Wigan, Eng. Medical Officer of Health. Annual report. Wigan, 1910-15; 1917-22; 1929- --- Willesden, England. Willesden, Eng. Medical Officer of Health. Annual report Lond., 35., 1910- --- Williamsport, Pennsylvania. Williamsport, Pa. Board of Health. Annual report. Williamsport, 1903-15. --- Wilmington, Delaware. Wilmington, Del. Board of Health. Annual report. Wilmington, 1881-82; 1890-98; 1902-16. --- Biennial report Wilmington, 1924- --- Wilmington [& New Hanover County] North Carolina. Wilmington & New Hanover County, N. Car. Board of Health. Monthly report. Wilmington, 1915-20. --- Winnipeg, Manitoba. Winnipeg, Manitoba. Health Depart- ment. Report. Winnipeg, 1908- HEALTH ORGANIZATION ---- Winona, Minnesota. Winona, Minn. Board of Health. Annual report Winona, 1., 1885; 1892-1907; 1930- ---- Winston-Salem, North Carolina. Winston-Salem, N. Car. Department of Health. Annual report Winston-Salem, 2.-7., 1918-23. ---- Wisconsin, U. S. A. Wisconsin. State Board of Health. Annual [and biennial] report., Madison, 1., 1876- ---- Bulletin. Madison, v.l, 1904- ---- Quarterly bulletin. Madison, v.6, 1941- Dearholt, H. E. Glimpses of pioneer Wisconsin health work. Wisconsin M. J., 1932, 31: 774-8.—Harper, C. A. Wiscon- sin's progress in conquering disease shown graphically by State Board of Health Charts. Ibid., 1924-25, 23: 624-9. ----- A brief outline of public health development in Wisconsin. Ibid., 1931, 30: 803-6. ---- Woburn, Massachusetts. Woburn, Mass. Board of Health. Annual report. Woburn, 1897-1913. ---- Wolverhampton, England. Wolverhampton, Eng. Medical Officer of Health. Annual report. Wolverhampton, 1884-1934. ---- Wood County, West Virginia. Wood County, W. Va. Health Depart- ment. Annual report Parkersburg, 1935-36. ---- Woolwich, England. Woolwich, Eng. Medical Officer of Health. Annual report. Lond., 1851; 1889; 1909- ---- Worcester, England. Worcester, Eng. Medical Officer of Health. Annual report. Worcester, 10., 1883; 16., 1889; 37., 1910- ---- Worcester, Massachusetts. Worcester, Mass. Department of Health. Annual report. Worcester, 1880- ---- Wyoming, U. S. A. Wyoming. State Board of Health. Bi- ennial report. Cheyenne, 1., 1911- ---- York, England. York, Eng. Medical Officer of Health. Annual report. York [1935] ---- Youngstown, Ohio. Youngstown, Ohio. Board of Health. Annual report. Youngstown, 1893; 1906-15. ■--- Yugoslavia. Yugoslavia. Ministere de la sante pu blique. Bulletin mensuel. Beograd, v. 1-4, 1921-25. Abel. Eindrucke von einer hygienischen Studienreise nach Jugoslavien. Munch, med. Wschr., 1926, 73: 492-5 — Beard, J. L. Public health in Serbia. Hosp. Soc. Serv., 1922, 5: 22-5.—Cavaillon. La protection de la sante publique en Yougo-Slavie; constatations faites au cours d'un voyage d'6tudes. Ann. hyg., Par., 1925, n. ser., 3: 551-77— Stampar, A. The public health programme of Yugoslavia. Internat. J. Pub. Health, Geneve, 1921, 2: 384-7.—Stuart, E. Sanita- tion in Serbia. Am. J. Pub. Health, 1920, 10: 124-31. —— Zanzibar Protectorate. Zanzibar Protectorate. Director of Med- ical Services. Annual medical and sanitary report. Zanzibar, 1909- 227475—vol. 7, 4th series----13 HEALTH ORGANIZATION ---- Zurich, Switzerland. Ratti, A. Di alcuni impianti, istituzioni e servizi della Citt& di Zungo. Gior. Soc. ital. igiene, 1916, 38: 265-71. HEALTH passbook. Zilberman, U. O. *Livret individuel de sante et d'etat civil. 36p. 8? Par., 1937. Furst, T. Die konstitutionshygienische Bedeutung des Gesundheitsstammbuches. Miinch. med. Wschr., 1935, 82: 750.—Medical inspection and health passbooks (Belgium) J. Am. M. Ass., 1939, 112: 2188.—Zemplenyi, I. [Practical intro- duction of personal health records] Orv. hetil., 1938, 82: 910-3. HEALTH, public. See also Group, Health; Health board; Health inspector; Health law; Health nurse; Health officer; Hygiene, public. Parrish, G. Health, the paramount asset. 262p. 8? [Los Ang., 1928] Armstrong, D. B., & Lentz, J. Credit lines; a selective digest of diversified health interests. Am. J. Pub. Health, 1940, 30: 1114; passim.—Banov, L. The practical side of public health. South. M. J., 1935, 28: 65-7.—Batkis, G. A. [Clinical aspect of hygiene] Vrach. delo, 1940, 22: 459-62.—Blanco Acevedo, E. Hechos y doctrinas sobre salud publica. Bol. Of. san. panamer., 1934, 13: 99-105.—Chaddock, R. E. Records of health and sanitary progress. Pub. Am. Statist. Ass., 1914-15, 14: 319- 34. Also Pub. Health Nurs., 1913, 5: 39-47.—Chandler, J. F. Public health; the truth. J. Missouri M. Ass., 1938, 35: 175- 8.—Chapin, C. V. Science and public health. Am. J. Pub. Health, 1927, 17: 1109-16.— Chimene, E. O. Relative values in public health work. Texas J. M., 1936-37, 32: 551-4.— Delort, M. La sante publique. J. mid. Paris, 1930, 1: 913- 9.—Dominguez, A. F. Pobrecitos leguleyos. Siglo m6d., 1936, 97: 152.—Evans, W. A. Public health. J. Lancet, 1930, 50: 603-12.—Foard, F. T. Public health. Med. Rec, N. Y., 1938, 148: 5-7.—Haggard, H. W. Who owns health? Pub. Health Nurs., 1936, 28: 214-21.—Ide, M. La fausse hygiene. Rev. mid., Louvain, 1923, 343-8.—Jackson, G. C. The meaning of public health to the local area. Bull. Texas Dep. Health, 1939, n. ser., 1: No. 7, 14-6.—Kemper, A. J. Public health, its meaning, history, early problems and modern accomplishments. West Virginia M. J., 1932, 28: 305-9.—Lewis, D. M. The purchasability of public health. Am. Physician, 1921, 26: 451.—Little, W. L. Public health values as seen by the presi- dent of a State Medical Association. J. Connecticut M. Soc, 1938, 2: 235.—Lord Tweedsmuir on health. Health, Toronto, 1936, 4: 5; 25.—McCreary, A. B. What is public health? Health Notes, Jacksonville, 1937, 29: 101-5.— Mahaffey, J. L. Public Health. Pub. Health News, Trenton, 1935, 19: 503-8.— Mensaje a la Sanidad de Centro-America. Bol. San. Guatemala, 1938, 9 550-2.—Niblack, H. C. Public health point of view. Illinois M. J., 1936, 70: 259-61.—Old, H. N. Cross connections. Health Off., Wash., 1939, 4: 259-61.—Pearl, R. The statistical evaluation of public health activities. Am. J. Pub. Health, 1922, 12: 915-21.—Quali sorti aspettano l'igiene pubblica? Gior. farm, chim., Tor., 1870, 19: 85-92.—Smellie, E. L. Common sense and public health. Canad. Nurse, 1934, 30: 118-20.—Spencer, R. R. The commonhealth; race and place. Health Off., Wash., 1938, 2: 436-45. ----— The common- health; the most marvelous of mechanisms. Ibid., 496-503. ------ The commonhealth; the most interesting subject in the world. Ibid., 3: 23-8.—Sydenstricker, E. The changing concept of public health. Milbank Mem. Fund Q., 1935, 13: 301-10. ---- Committees and societies. American Public Health Association. Yearbook, supplement to Am. J. Pub. Health. N. Y., 1930-31- AUSTRALIAN HEALTH SOCIETY. Melb. [Pamphlets; 1876-98] Cincinnati, Ohio. Public Health Federa- tion. Annual report (1928-29) Cincin., 1929. Model answers to questions set by the Sanitary Institute and the Sanitary Associa- tion of Scotland. (4. S.) 117p. 12? Lond., 1901. New South Wales. The health society. Report. 8p. 20#cm. Sydney, 1911. Rhode Island. An act to incorporate the Sanitary Protection Association of Newport; passed April 9, 1879. 1 1. 4? Newport, 1882. Arbona, G. Are we public health conscious? Bol. As. mid. Puerto Rico, 1941, 33: 201-5.—Arnold, M. New York's district health committees. Pub. Health Nurs., 1939, 31: 206-8.—Associazione italiana Fascista per l'igiene. Italia san., 1932, 24: No. 15-16, 3.—Beall, L. G. Health conservation as HEALTH, PUBLIC 194 HEALTH, PUBLIC an economic factor. Charlotte M. J., 1915, 72: 178-82.— Beninde, M. Zur Vierteljahrhundertfeier des Yereins fiir Wasser-, Mmlen- und Lufthygiene. Kleine Milt. Verein Wasservetsorg., 1927, 3: 75-112—Bigelow, G. H. The rela- tion of clinics and health associations lo the medical profession. N. England M. J 1930 202: 949-53.—Blumer, G. The rela- tion of clinics and health associations to the medical profession. Ibid., 999-1001.—Cassidy, H. M. The economic value of public health. Canad. Pub. Health J., 1932, 23: 51-8 — Clark, T. H. Report of the National Health Conservation Committee. Med. Insur., 1926, 42: 143-50.—Depretis, U. Cenno sommario dell'attivit& svolta dalla Reale Society italiana di igiene in oltre un cinquantennio di vita. Gior. Soc. ital. igiene, 1936, 58: 129-32.—Eichhoff. Entwicklung und Ziele des Vereins fiir Wasser-, Boden- und Lufthygiene E. V., Berlin-Dahlem. Techn. Gemeindebl., 1927-28, 30: 57 — Emerson, H. Public health as a private responsibility. Hosp. Social Serv., 1929, 29: 350-6.—Frankel, L. K. A plea for a National Health Association. Pub. Health J., Toronto, 1927, 18: 51-7.—Frost, W.H. Authoritative standards and associa- tion policy. Am. J. Pub. Health, 1936, 26: 336-42.—Golley, W. Utilization of community resources by lay committees. Michi- gan Pub. Health, 1940, 28: 151-7.—LaPorte, J. N. Let each do his share. BuU. hyg., Montreal, 1941, 27: No. 3, 8-10 — Lee, R. I. The relation of clinics and health associations to the medical profession. N. England M. J., 1930, 202: 945-7 — Lehman, H. H. An equal opportunity for health. Am. J. Pub. Health, 1938, 28: 1-6.—MacEachern. M. T., Coffey, W. L. [et al.l Report of committee on public health relations. Bull. Am. Hosp. Ass., 1931, 5: 98-121.—Marsh, B. C. Economic foundations for health. Med. Insur., 1917, 26: 253-6. Also N. York State J. M., 1917, 67: 184-7.—Mochel. R. J. Defend- ing a county's health; how a small association functions in an average mid-west community. Bull. Nat. Tuberc. Ass., 1941, 27: 155.—Mulfinger, C. L. The Public Health League of California. Med. Rev. of Rev., 1934, 40: 418-20.—National health and medical research council. Health, Canberra, 1937, 15: 73. New Mexico Public Health Association annual meet- ing, Santa Fe, April 30, May 1, 1935. N. Mexico Health Off., 1935, 5: 4.— Nichols, S. H. Report of the sub-committee on public health. J. M. Soc. N. Jersey, 1936, 33: 276-80. The sub-committee on public health and its 10 advisory com- mittees; report of the sub-committee on public health. Ibid., 1939, 36: 293-6.—Ober, F. R. The relation of clinics and health associations to the medical profession. N. England M. J., 1930, 202: 953-6.—Ottolenghi. D. L'opera dell'Associazione Nazionale Fascist a per l'igiene e il programma del X Congresso d'igiene a Napoli. Igiene mod., 1936, 29: 325-35.—Pinkhof, H. [The Jewish Association for the Promotion of Hygiene] Ned. tschr. geneesk., 1926, 70: pt 2, 876-81.—Preliminary program of the scientific sessions of the 69th annual meeting of the American Public Health Association, the 21st annual meeting of the Michigan Public Health Association, meetings of related organizations, and of the seventh Institute on public health education (Detroit, Oct. 6-11, 1940) Am. J. Pub. Health, 1940, 30: 972-1013.—Rabiner, B. I., White, E. [et al.] Report of committee on pubhc health and welfare. N. Jersey J. Pharm., 1939, 12: No. 11, 63-6.—Reichel, H. Funfzig Jahre Oesterreichische Oesellschaft fur (jesundheitspflege. Mitt. Volksgesundhamt., Wien, 1932, 17-9.—Report of the Executive board to the governing council. Am. J. Pub. Health, 1940, 30: No. 2, Suppl., 39-44.—[Report of the Netherland Society of Water, Soil, Air, held March 10th, 1937 concerning the question; Is Northern Holland to remain brackish?] Water Bodem Luclit, 1937, 27: 17-43- Richardson, D. L. The relation of clinics and health associations to the medical profession. N. England M. J., 1930, 202: 947-9.—Rollesion, H. Lay pioneers in the common health. Canad. Pub. Health J., 1939, 30: 1-3.— Russell, A. H. PubUc health; the foundation of nation build- ing. Ind. M. Gaz., 1939. 74: 290. Also Ind. M. Rec, 1939, 59: 73-5.—Savonen, S. [The activity of the Peoples Association in relation to hygiene] Duodecim, Helsin., 1938, 54: 305-18.— Seiffert, G. Aufgaben und Leistungen der Bayerischen Arbeitsgemeinschaft zur Forderung der Volksgesundheit. Munch, med. Wschr., 1928, 75: 1085-8.—Sixty-eighth annual meeting, American Public Health Association Kansas City Mo., October 25-29, 1938. J. Am. M. Ass., 1938, 111: 1775.— Syrkin, L. A. LActivity of the Moscow hygienic society from June 1938 untU April 1939] Gig. san., Moskva, 1939, 4: No. 7, 41-3.—Terry, W. I. California's League for the conservation of pubUc health. California West. M„ 1925, 23: 1419-23.— Thirtieth annual meeting: Canadian Public Health Association Quebec, June 9th-llth, 1941. Canad. Pub. Health J., 1941, 32: 271-82.—Trawick. K. H. Lay participation in pubUc health work. Pub. Health Nurs., 1934, 26: 604-7.—Twenty-seventh annual meeting, Canadian Public Health Association in con- junction with the annual meeting of the Nova Scotia Health Officers Association, Halifax, June 20, 21, 22. Canad Pub Health J., 1938, 29: 22.5- 32— Underwood, F. J. Health, a job for all. Proc. Conf. Health Author. N. America (1939) 1940 54. meet., 15-20.— What is the health league of Canada? Health, Toronto, 1940, 8: 15.—Who is responsible for the health of the individual' In Am. Med. (Am. Found.) N. Y 1937 1 • 78-80— Widdemer. K. D. The citizen. N. York State J M 1940, 40: 1501-6. ---- History and progress. Galland, P. *L'eglise et l'hygiene au moyen age. 220p. 8? Par., 1933. Blake, T. H. Stiides in public health. West Virginia M. J., 1937, 33: 25-S. Boudreau, F. G. New health frontiers. Proc. Milbank Mem. Fund 1937. 15. Conf., 7-18. ------Modern health trends. Ibid., 193* lb. Conf., 5-11.—Bow, M. R. Public health yesterday, to-da\. and to-morrow. Canad. I'ub Health .)., 1937. 28: 311-7. Brown, B. P. Public health in 1940. Week. Bull. California Dep. Pub. Health, 1940 II, 19: 138.—Changing (The) concept of public health. Canad. Pub. Health J., 1936, 27: 19.--Clark. R. V. Imagination in public health. Pub. Health, Lond., 1934, 48: 58-63.-Cleere, R. L The changing concept of public health. Rocky Mountain M. J., 1938, 35: 525-9.—Dresel. E. G. Oeffentliches Gesundheits- wesen einst und jetzt. Hippokrates, Stuttg., 1936, 7: 421-7.— Flexner, S. Scientific discovery and public health. In Policies Pub. Health (Milbank Mem. Fund) N. Y., 1935, 90-6.— Garnet, R. W. Some developments in public health. Virginia M. Month., 1927-28, 54: 135-8.—Hague, E. W. J. Some modern tendencies in public health work. Pub. Health J., Toronto, 1924, 15: 521-7.—Higgins. T. S. Public health influences. S. Afr. M. J., 1934, 8: 674-80.—Holmes. F. M. Veterihary science and public health. J. State M., Lond., 1934, 42: 355-62.—Julyan, A. J. C. W. Prospect and retrospect in public health. J. R. San. Inst., 1931, 51: 603-6.—Krusen, W. Progress in public health. J. Am. Inst. Homeop., 1926, 19: 875-82.—Mohr, C. A. Progress in public health. J. M. Ass. Alabama, 1935-36, 5: 181-4.—Morrow, J. R. Public health of tomorrow. J. M. Soc. N. Jersey, 1940, 37: 462-5. Also Pub. Health News, Trenton, 1940, 24: 104-11.—Mountin, J. W. Orientation in public health. Am. J. Pub. Health, 1939, 29: 1193-204.—Parran, T. Public health today. Proc. Interst. Postgrad. M. Ass. N.America, 1936, 237-42.------Modern tendencias de la sanidad publica. Actas Conf. Panamer. dir. nac. san., 1936, 3: 129-37.------ Trends in public health. Ann. Int. M., 1938-39, 12: 115-20.—Ruhland, G. C. The newer public health. Med. Ann. District of Columbia, 1936, 5: 1-5.—Sawyer, W. A. Three frontiers in public health. Pub. Health Nurs., 1940, 32: 21-5.—State (The) of the public health. J. R. Army M. Corps, 1936, 66: 39-45.—Willoughby, W. G. Public health today and to-morrow. Brit. M. J., 1931, 2: 131-5. Also Lancet, Lond., 1931, 2: 171-3.—Winslow, C. E. A. PubUc health at the crossroads. Am. J. Pub. Health, 1926, 16: 1075-85. ---- Physicians' interests. De Kruif, P. H. Men against death. 363p. 8? N. Y. [1932] Miller, J. A., Williams, L. R., & Smith, T. Public health and the practising physician. 27p. 8? N. Y., 1929. Rankin, W. S. Medicine and public health. 8p. 8? Wash., 1930. Forms No. 4 Miscellaneous Contr. Costs Med. Care. Abell, I. The aims of the medical profession as they relate to the public. J. Am. M. Ass., 1938, 110: 2041-4.—Ailes, A. The county medical society; its duties and responsibilities in relation to public health. Illinois M. J., 1930, 58: 329-33 — Alexander, W. W. Community health as interpreted by a private practitioner. J. M. Ass. Alabama, 1939-40, 9: 377-9 — Alsever, W. D. Public health and the medical profession; the spirit of mutual helpfulness. Proc. Conf. San. Off. N. York, 1910, 10: 65-74.—Anders, J. M. The College of Physicians and the public health. Tr. Coll. Physicians Philadelphia, 1912, 3. ser., 34: 3243.—Appel, T. B. Public health and medical profession. Hahneman. Month., 1928, 63: 1-12.—Arms, B. L. Public health activities and the physician. Maine M. J., 1937, 28: 25-7.—Banov, L. The physician and the public health. J. S. Carolina M. Ass., 1937, 33: 255-8.—Bates, H. T. The general practitioner and public health. Pub. Health, Lond., 1932 45: 236-8.—Bauer, W. W. The physician's place in the health program. J. Am. M. Ass., 1936, 107: 485-87.—Belam, F. A. The private practitioner and public health. Brit. M. J„ 1933, 1: Suppl., 159-61.—Birk. Aerztliche Aufgaben im Rahmen der Bevolkerungspolitik des Staates. Deut. med. Wschr. 1938, 64: 500.—Blue, J. A. The doctor's relation to pubhc health. J. Oklahoma M. Ass., 1941, 34: 294.—Blumer, G. Reconstruction and the medical profession. Am. Med., 1919, n ser 14: 457-65.—Brooks, H. The physician and the pubhc health. J. Am. M. Ass., 1927, 89: 8-11.—Buttersack. Der praktische Arzt im Dienste des Volksganzen. Aerztl. Rdsch., 1933, 43: 243-5.—Carl an, D. El esquema del pro- grama sanitario y profesional medico. Siglo med., 1936, 97: 145.—Carpenter, G. A., Darrow, K., & Morris, A. C. The local medical society and public health. J. Am. M. Ass., 1928, 90j .r4-Co°Per, C. E. Doctor, patient and state. Colo- rado M., 1933, 30: 122-34— Cooper. G. M. PubUc health work for the young doctor. North CaroUna M. J., 1941, 2: ll- r7CorbuB, B. R. Social legislation and the doctor. J. Michigan M. Soc, 1913, 12: 149-53.—Cumming. H. S. Rela- tionships in medical and pubUc health work. South. M. J., ZV \ ' ,2?~31- ------ The relations of the physician to pubhc health. J. Am. M. Ass., 1927, 89: 4-8. ------ PubUc health and the medical profession. In Policies Pub. Health (Milbank Mem. Fund) N. Y., 1935, 82-9.—Davison, R. O. I he use of the profession in part-time health activities. Proc. Conf. Health Author. N. America, 1936, 51: 73-7.—De Borde- nave, E. A. A means for better protection of our communities HEALTH, PUBLIC 195 HEALTH, PUBLIC from disease, and by which our aged professional brother can be assisted. Old Dominion J. M. & S., Richmond, 1909, 9: 402-8—Dildy, J. E. The relation of the general practitioner to public health. Texas J. M., 1913-14, 9: 188-90.—Doucette, F. E. Public health and medical cooperation. Southwest J. M. & S., 1933, 17: 151-3.—Draper, W. F. The year's progress in health work relating to the medical profession. Virginia M. Month., 1933, 60: 133-8.—Dumez, A. G. There is need for broader and more effective cooperation among the health- service professions. Am. J. Pharm. Educ, 1941, 5: 320-9.— Emerson, H. Will the private practitioner determine the future of pubUc health work. N. York State J. M., 1916, 16: 223-9.—Emerson. K. The practicing physician and pubUc health. South. M. J., 1933, 26: 31-6. Also Diplomate, 1934, 6- 251-7.—Family (The) physician in the community health service. Westchester M. Bull., 1934, 2: No. 6, 1.—Fleming, A. G. The general practitioner in public health. Canad. M. Ass. J., 1930, 22: 42-6.—Forsyth, W. W. The role of the general practitioner. J. R. San. Inst., 1937-38, 58: 645-8.— Fowler, T. An address on medical practitioners and pubUc health. Brit. M. J., 1907, 2: 1763.—Gebbie, N. The general medical practitioner and the public health service. Med. Off., Lond., 1935, 53: 175.—Geib, L. O., & Vaughan, H. F. The physician as health worker. J. Am. M. Ass., 1931, 97: 366-9. Also repr.—Graham-Little, E. Medical education and the pubhc health. J. State M., Lond., 1934, 42: 63-75.—Haggard, H. W. The function of the general practitioner in public health work. N. England J. M., 1934, 210: 584-7.—Harris, S. Medical and pubUc health needs, and advice to young doctors. J. M. Ass. Alabama, 1938-39, 8: 369-86.—Hogarth, A. H. The medical practitioner as an asset to preventive medicine. Brit. M. J., 1918, 2: 519.—Holbrook, A. T. The relations of the physician to pubUc health, from the standpoint of the physician in the smaU city. J. Am. M. Ass., 1927, 89: 1-4.—Irion, C. H. The economic relation of the physician to the sanitary interests of the State. N. Orleans M. & S. J., 1908, 61: 125-32 — Kacprzak, M. [Movements in contemporary hygiene and the practician] Warsz. czas. lek., 1933, 10: 45; 67; 93.—Kelley, E. R. The medical profession and the new pubUc health. Proc. Connecticut M. Soc, 1918, 126: 90-8.—Kliewer, R. Role of the doctor of medicine in the Ufe and health of the American citizen. California West. M., 1941, 55: 32-5.—Larumbe, J. E. Salubridad y los medicos. Rev. mex. cir., 1941, 9: 25-7.— Leathers, W. S. PubUc health and the practicing physician. N. Orleans M. & S. J., 1932, 85: 387-94.—Lee, T. B. Physi- cians and other health agencies. J. M. Soc. N. Jersey, 1934, 31: 640-2.—Lewis, R. H. The physician and the public health. Bull. N. Carolina Bd. Health, 1910-11, 25: 372-5.—Lick, M. A charge to keep. Pennsylvania M. J., 1936-37, 40: 1-8.— Lillie, C. W. The doctor and the pubUc health. Ilhnois M. J., 1916, 29: 401; 1920, 38: 190.—Linde, J. I. The Connecticut way; the State medical society's participation in public health. Connecticut M. J., 1940, 4: 443-6.—Lingenfelder, J. The gen- eral practitioner; guardian of public health. J. Missouri M. Ass., 1931, 28: 593-5.—Lumsden, L. L. Public health and private practice. J. Am. M. Ass., 1921, 77:779-82.—McCreary. A. B. The final responsibility of public health rests on the medical profession. J. Florida M. Ass., 1938-39, 25: 181-7 — MacNalty, A. The general practitioner and public health. Canad. M. Ass. J., 1939, 41: 193-5.—Maday, T. H. The physician and human nature. Clin. Med., 1941, 48: 102-5.— Mahony, F. O. The relationship between public health and the practicing physician. J. Arkansas M. Soc, 1934, 30: 173-6.— Medical practice and the health of the people. Brit. M. J., 1935, 1: 1322.—Meyer. T. R. Medical participation in a public health program. J. Missouri M. Ass., 1938, 35: 343-7.— Miller, J. A. The effect of the public health programme upon the interests of the private physician. N. York State J. M., 1929, 29: 591-6.—Miller, J. B. The role of the general prac- titioner. J. R. Inst. Pub. Health, 1939, 2: 121-5.—Milne, J. A. The importance of the private physician in a public health program. South. M. J., 1935, 28: 855-8.—Musser, J. H. Public health and the general practitioner. N. Orleans M. & S. J., 1941-42, 94: 137-42.—Osborn, S. H. Problems and opportunities in public health and the relation of practicing physicians thereto. N. England J. M., 1932, 206: 877-82.— Paden, R. H. The pediatrician and the private practice of public health. West Virginia M. J., 1933, 29: 120-6.—Pritchard S. Medical participation in public health. J. Michigan M. Soc, 1934, 33: 508-10.—Public health and the physician. Week. Bull. Dep. Health N. York, 1923, n. ser., 12: 137-44 — Puckett, C. The medical profession and the public health. Nat. Eclect. M. Ass. Q., 1925-26, 17: 89-92.—Rankin. W. S. The potentialities of public health as an organizing factor in medicine. South. M. J., 1924, 17: 7-11.—Redfearn, J. A. The physician's part in the public health program. J. M. Ass. Georgia, 1933, 22: 50-2.—Ross. W. H. The relationship of the practicing physician to public health. Bull. Maryland Dep. Health, 1931, 2: 21-7.------Public relations of medi- cine; the physician and a health-conscious pubUc. J. M. Soc. N. Jersey, 1934, 31: 226.—Ruhland, G. C. Public health and private practice. Am. J. Pub. Health, 1931, 21: 267-71.— Schlaeger. Der Arzt als Hygieniker. Zschr. arztl. Fortbild., 1928, 25: 774.—Scott, J. A. The general practitioner and the public health service. Pub. Health, Lond., 1934, 48: 90-4.— Sedgwick, W. T. Modern medicine and the public health. Pub. Health Rep., Wash., 1921, 36: 109-16.—Sharpley, W. H. Physicians and the public health. Denver M. Times, 1909, 29: 228-31.—Smith, W. F. Some suggestions looking to the im- provement of the public health by the general practitioner. Northwest M., 1918, 17: 255-9. Also Med. Insur., 1918-19, 28: 7; 55.—Stephenson, F. B. Public health and the medical profession. Colorado M., 1932, 29: 393.—Tellez, O. Opor- tunidades profesionales en el campo de la sanidad. Cr6n. mid., Lima, 1934, 51: 279-98.—Thomson, A. N. The place of the medical profession in the public health program. N. York State J. M., 1940, 40: 1498-501.—Underwood, F. J. The general practitioner and the pubUc health program. Ann. Int. M., 1931, 5: 65-9.—Vaughan, H. F. Medical participation in nubhc health work. Am. J. Pub. Health, 1932, 22: 933 — Vaughan, V. C. The doctor's dream. Proc. Ass. Life Insure. Pres., 1913, 7: 94-102. Also Science, 1914, n. ser., 39: 149-54.— Vonderlehr, R. A. Increasing opportunities for the clinician in public health work. J. Nat. M. Ass., N. Y., 1940, 32: 93-6.— Wallace, J. The relation of the practising physician to public health activities. Canad. M. Ass. J., 1928, 19: 449-55.— Wegener, G. G. Arzt und Volk in gemeinsamer Arbeit an der Volksgesundheit. Hippokrates, Stuttg., 1939, 10: 625.— Werle, T. J. Tomorrow's health; the doctors dilemma. Mod. Med., Chic, 1920, 2: 322-4.—Wilkes, L. A. The private physician in the community health program. J. M. Soc. N. Jersey, 1932, 29: 839-49.—Williams, E. G. The relation of the general practitioner to public health work [Abstr.] Virginia M. Semi-Month., 1908-9, 13: 417.—Wilson, W. H. The medical profession, public health, and the public. Nebraska M. J., 1929, 14: 197-201.—Woolner, W. The place of the family doctor in a public health program. Canad. Pub. Health J., 1935, 26: 381-3.—Wu Lien-Teh. The private medical prac- titioner in relation to public health. Rep. Nat. Quarant. Serv., China, 1934, ser. 5, 109-14.—Wylder, M. K. The family physician as a public health agent. Southwest. M., 1939, 23: 1-3.—Wyman, W. Relation of the physician in private practice to the public health. J. Am. M. Ass., 1909, 52: 1899-904. ---- Practice. Hemenway, H. B. American public health protection. 283p. 8? Indianap. [1916] United States. The National Institute of Health. How to conserve public health, the most important problem confronting mankind; remarks of Joseph E. Randsell, Royal S. Cope- land [et al.] 52p. 8? Wash., 1931. Bedinger, G. R. Cooperative health plan in New York County. Nation's Health, Chic, 1921, 3: 486-9.—Belt, E. PubUc health activities and responsibilities. California West. M., 1941, 55: 30-2.—Boehme, G. F. A method of health con- servation. Med. Rec, N. Y., 1918, 94: 722. Also repr.— Chapin.C. V. Effective Unes of health work. Providence M. J., 1916, 17: 12-22.—Dinwiddie, C. A new experiment in team work for the public health. Mod. Hosp., 1918, 11: 180-2.— Draper, W. F. Virginia plan of cooperative county health work. Am. J. Pub. Health, 1921, 11: 801-6—Grixoni, G., De Bernardinis, L.t & Ilvento, A. Collaborazione delle autoritik civiU e militari competenti in materia d'igiene, di educazione fisica e di profilassi, statistica demografica delle malattie sociali: tubercolosi, malattie veneree, alcoolismo, tare psichiche, ricerca dei sintomi iniziali, azione profilattica concertata, vaccinazioni. Gior. med. mil., 1923, 71: 338-60—Grosz, E. [What can we expect by organized work in public health?] Orv. hetil., 1941, 85: 214.—Kebler, L. F. Public health conserved through the enforcement of postal fraud laws. Am. J. Pub. Health, 1922, 12: 678-83.—Littlejohn, D. Civic activities in public health and public health in civic activities. J. Michigan M. Soc, 1920, 19: 489-94.—Lythgoe, H. C. Just a little routine. Common- health, Bost., 1939, 26: 170-2.— Nichols, S. Fundamental principles. J. M. Soc. N. Jersey, 1937, 34: 12-8.—Pierce, C. C. Co-operation in public health activities. Proc. Am. Conf. Pharm., 1920, 21: 25-46.—Rice, J. L., & Barnard, M. W. Administration sanitaria en las grandes poblaciones. Bol. Of. san. panamer., 1936, 15: 858-64.—Roberson, L. V. Health advice from far-off India. Good Health, 1935, 70: 270 — Rothfuss, P. A. Public health and the citizen. Pennsylvania Health, 1935, 13: No. 4, 5-8.—Ruediger, G. F. Co-operation in public health work by neighboring small cities. Illinois M. J., 1915, 28: 96-101.—Ruzicka, S. [Hygienic system, based on eubiotics, a new science] Cas. 16k. Cesk., 1927, 66: 1813-5.— S., F. C. Home rule in public health. Week. Roster, Phila., 1940-41,36: 1513.—Schnelle. Wissenschaft und Dilettantismus in der Hygiene; freie Bahn dem Tuchtigen! Fortsch. Med., 1933, 51: 347-50.—Vincent, G. E. The University and public health. Johns Hopkins Univ. Circ, 1919, 4-13.—Washburn, B. E. Brief remarks on public health work. Puerto Rico Health Bull., 1939, 3: 47.—Winslow, F. S., & Johnson. W. M. Partners in public health. South. M. A: S., 1936, 98: 610-12 — Woodward, W. C. Ways and means of bringing matters of public health to social usefulness. Proc. Pan Pacific Sc Congr., Wash. (1915-16) 1917, 9: 526-9. ---- Problems. Lerrigo, M. O. *Health problem sources [Columbia Univ.] 151p. 8? N. Y., 1926. Acuna, P. S. Delicias de la superstici6n. In his Un rimero d. verd., 2. ed., B. Air., 1938, 131.—Bijl, J. P., Dornickx, G. J., & Julius, H. W. [Present greatest dangers to public health] HEALTH, PUBLIC 196 HEALTH RESORT Ned. tschr. geneesk., 1940, 84: 1987.— Boudreau, F. G. New light on old health problems. Proc. Milbank Mem. Fund., 1939, 17: 5-10.— Dunn, H. L. Human relations as a public health problem. Am. J. Pub. Health, 1940, 30: 1318-22.—Ferrell, J. A. A few health problems awaiting solution. South. M. J., 1936, 29: 635-7.—Garcia Canal, M. ^Debiera implantarse el delito sanitario? Inform, mid., Yalladolid, 1932, 9: 213-8.— Long, J. D. Some speculative observations relative to future public health problems. Proc. M. Ass. Canal Zone, 1927, 15: 31-6.—Mountain, J. W. Report of round-table on health problems of adult life. Proc. Milbank Mem. Fund, 1937, 15: [Discussion] 46—60.—Murillo, F. Los enemigos de la humani- dad al mat gen de un borrador) Siglo mid., 1934, 93: 290-5 — Mustard, H. S. Taking our bearings in public health. Illinois Health Mess., 1939, 11: 20--3.—Pearl, R. The significance of some general biologic principles in public health problems. J. Am. M. Ass., 1920, 74: 375-8— Rodenwaldt, E., & Zeiss, H. Lebenskreise; ein Aufruf an die deutschen Hvgieniker. Zschr. Hyg.. 193S 39, 121: H. 3, p. i-iv.—Roney, Lady J. P. Women and children and the public health. Nat. Health Rev., Ottawa, 1938, 6: 92. —Rorem, C. R. Health problems from the lavman's point of view. .Minnesota M., 1937, 20: 642-6.—Thompson, W. S. Future population trends and their significance for health work. J. Med., Cincin., 1935-36, 16: 509-14. ---- in war. See War, Public health aspects. HEALTH resort. See also Altitude; Balneography; Camp; Climatology; Mineral water, &c. Breckinridge, A. Health resorts. Hygeia, Chic, 1937, 15: No. 8, 728 30.—Climatic research at the health resort; im- portance and possibilities; draft report of the I. S. M. H. Com- mittee for hioclimatnlogv October 1937. Arch. M. Hydr., Lond., 1938, 16: 70 2. lakovenko, V. A. [Method of resultant temperature in practical computation of climates of health re- sorts] Vopr. kurort., 1941, No. 2, 8-15. Kerschensteiner, H. Antike Heilstatten; neue Ausgrabungen. Miinch, med. Wschr., 1934, 81: 1941-4.—Lampert, H. Kurorte, Statten der Erho- lung. Deut. med. Wschr., 1936, 62: Sonderausg. B, 17.— Pathault, L. Du sanatorium k la medecine naturelle. Marseille med., 1936, 73: pt 2, 7; 41.-Wallace. A. W. The modern health resort. J. Am. M. Ass., 1936, 107: 419-21.—Zalkindson, E. T. [The neurogalvanie reflex (galvunometry) and its appli- cation as method for determining physical and health-resort factors] Fizioterapia, Moskva, 1939, 63 7. ---- Congresses and societies. Comit6 d'Hygidne et d'assistance sociale de la Soci6t6 de pediatric Bull. Soc. pediat. Paris, 1936, 34: 794-801.— Jaspar. M. H. Congrds de la F6d6ration internationale des stations thermales, climatiques et maritimes. Bull. san. pub., Brux., 1939, 4: 471-3.—Poirier, A. P. C Le congres interna- tional du thermalisme et du climatism, Paris, 15-17 octobrc 1937. Rev. Serv. san. mil., Par., 1938, 108: 169. Wybauw, R. The health resort as national asset; a conference in Brussels. Lancet, Lond., 1935, 2: 974. ---- Geography. Biella, Italy. Ospizi (Gli) marini ed i poveri fanciulli scrofolosi della citta e circondario di Biella; relazione amministrativa sanitaria per l'anno 1872[-1879] 8v. 22>/2cm. Biella, 1873- [1880] Montecatini, Italy. Stabilimento Igea (Ca- scine e Chalet svizzero) ai bagni di Montecatini nella Val di Nievole per la cura del latte e dell'uva e ritrovo di ricreazione. 15p. 21^cm. Firenze, 1888. Also another ed. lip. 24cm. Firenze 1888. Aleksandrov, V. A., & Leibenson, A. E. [Health resorts in the western Ukraine] Vopr. kurort., 1941, No. 2, 45-51.— Belot, J. Salies-de-Bearn, station d'enfants. J. mid. Bordeaux 1936, 113: 411-3.—Bodmer, H.. & Kallos, P. Ueber das Kurgebiet von Orselina. Schweiz. med. Wschr., 1934, 64: 129.—Bruce, G. R. Hastings as a health resort. Practitioner Lond., 1927, 118: 326-8.—Burkhardt. Das Deutsche Krieger- kurhaus Davos-Dorf. Deut. med. Wschr., 1936, 62: 942.— Burnet, J. British spas in winter. Med. Times, Lond., 1938, 66: 4.— Callegari. V. Resoconto sanitario suUa Colonia elioterapica diurna nei suo primo anno di funzionamento, 17 luglio-23 agosto 1937. Prat, pediat., Milano, 1938, 'l6: i95-207.—Constantin. Etude de l'ionisation atmospherique k Biarritz. Presse therm, chm., 1938, 79: 5-7.—Cuvier, G. Arcachon, station sp£cifique des inadaptSs urbains. J mid Bordeaux, 1938, 115: 280-3.— David, A. Les stations des Alpes et du Jura; k propcs du 17. V. E. M. J. sc mid Lille 1923, 41: pt 2, 242; 257.—Dietrich. Die Heilschatze der deut> schen Kurorte. Med. Welt, 1931, 5: 409-72.—Du Pasquier & Renard, M. La Maison thermale des assurances sociales de Seine et Seine-et-Oise k Saint-Hcnore-les-Bains, Nievre Mid. scol., Par., 1938, 27: 135-41.- Ev.seov. R. I. [Scientific activity and state of health resorts in Central Asia] Tr. (iosud. nauch. inst. fizioter. Semashko, 1934, 2: 120-4.----- & Beniaminov, H. M. [Health resorts in Czbekistan] Ibid., 74-119.—Forbes, I). Brighton as a health resort. Practitioner, Lond., 1927, 118: 322-5. -Giuntoli, A. II piano di risana- mento per il Quartiere di Santa Croce. Firenze (Rass.) 1936, 5: 41-7.—Goldberry, A. J. Notes from Switzerland. West London M. J., 1939, 44: 26-30. Hernandez Miyares, C. Las colonias infantiles en Cuba. Rev. med. cir. Habana, 1937, 42: 502-17.—Kornmann, F. Das Tessin als Kurgebiet. Schweiz. med. Wschr., 1934, 64: 127.— Mahony, H. T. Health hunting at an American Spa. Pub. Health Nurs., 1927, 19: 217-9.—Mascherpa, P. L'Etna ed alcune sue caratteristiche climatiche dal punto di vista degli studi biologici e della valorizzazione sanitaria di questa montagna. Riv. idroclim., 1S39, 50: 94-9.—Mastalerz, K. [Therapeutic value and sani- tary conditions of the health resorts in Zakopane] Polska gaz. lek., 1938, 17: 467.- -Mendes de Castro. Classes de saude, colonias de terias. (laz. clin., S. Paulo, 1941, 39: 299.— Michel, H., & Junca, E. Arcachon, ville d'enfants. J. med. Bordeaux, 1936, 113: 406-11.—Molinery. Les colonies de vacances et les camps thermaux. Rev. cosmobiol., Nice, 1935-36, 2: 101-6.—Nodia, M. I. [Health resorts of local significance and therapeutic stations of Georgian Soviet Republicj Vrach. delo, 1940, 22: 683-8.—[Pictures of the health resort in Podebrade] Cas. 16k. Cesk., 1940, 79: opp. p. 970.—Poudensan, G. Maison de convalescence et garderie scolaire estivale de la Caisse departementale d'assurances sociales de la Gironde. J. mid. Bordeaux, 1935,112:305.— Poulton, E. P. The relative advantages of British and foreign health resorts. Brit.M. J., 1934, 2: 1037-9.—Rembry, O. P. La maison familiale d'Aulnoye (Nord) Rev. mid. sociale, Par., 1938, 6: 308-13.— S., J. J. J. [Tenth anni- versary 1929-39 of the Harst Hulst rest house at Dolder] Croene & witte kruis, 1939, 35: 143.—Sand, R. Health cen- tres in Europe. Month. Bull. League Red Cross Soc, 1935, 16: No. 12, [219]-21.—Semaschko, N. Das Gesundheitswesen in Sowjet-Russland; das Kurortwesen. Deut. med. Wschr., 1924, 50: 1251-3.—Sicard. La colonie thermale d'Enghien. Mid. scol., Par., 1938, 27: 27-35.—Something new in Fins- bury. Lancet, Lend., 1938, 2: 1027.—Soviet (A) health resort [Kislovodsk] Ibid., 1937, 1: 45-7.—Stibor, J. [Classification and review of the Czech chmatic health resorts from the medical view-point] Vest. Cesk. fysiat. spol., 1939-40, 19: 93-104.—Trybowski. C. [Climate and health resorts] Polska gaz. lek., 1939, 18: 98-100.—Voyage (Un) d'etude au Maroc; Marrakech, station climatique d'hiver. Paris mdd. 1939, 112: 82-7.—Weaver, A. E. R. Weston-super-mare as a health resort. J. R. San. Inst., 1933, 54: 31-4.—Woods, R. S. Spa amenities. Lancet, Lond., 1938, 1: 694.—Zor- kendorfer, K. Das Heilgut des Sudetenlandes. Balneologe, 1939, 6: 1-5. ---- Management, and organization. Auer, E. M. Jugenderholungsheime und Gewerbeordnung. Zschr. Kinderschutz, 1937, 29: 1-3.—Bacmeister, A. Die Neuordnung des deutschen klimatischen Kurwesens. Miinch. med. Wschr., 1938, 85: 1107-12.—Barla-Szabo, J. [Medical principles in establishing a hospital in a health resort] Orv. hetil., 1939, 83: 593.—Behrend, W. Die Bedeutung der Heilstatten im Rahmen der Kurorte. Zschr. wiss. Baderk., 1928-29, 3: 1111-5.—Bibicescu, C. [Methods of functioning, organization and description of the Sanatorium Moroeni] Romania med., 1939, 17: 144-9.—Bonafe. Les difficulty d'application du climatique social dans les campagnes. Gaz. med. France, 1935, 42: 865.—Colbert. Notes sur l'organisa- tion sanitaire des stations climatiques, balneaires et thermales. Ibid 1939. 46: 29-36.—Cox, A. The health resort as a part of the public health service. J. R. San. Inst., 1935-36, 56: 299-303.—Dodds, E. C. Food at the health resort. Med. Press & Circ, Lond., 1936, 192: 508-9.—Gerke, O. Unter- suchungen in einer Pflegeanstalt; Anstalt, Krankenmaterial, beobachtete biologische Aenderungen. Schweiz. med. Wschr., 1929, 59: 890-3.—Godard, J., Radenac, J. [et al.] Les place- ments de la caisse interdepartementale en colonie sanitaire. Hev. mid. sociale, Par., 1939, 7: 179; 289.—Hirsch, M. Die deutschen Kurorte im Dienste der sozialen Fursorge. Zschr. wiss. Baderk., 1928-29, 3: 419-33.—Latzke. Strassenanlage und Staubbeseitigung mit besonderer Rucksicht auf die Kur- ort. Ibid., 1926-27, l:-2: 225-30.—Leati, A., & Graziosi, G. L mta di organizzazione e di coordinazione nei funzionamento delle colonie. Riv. idroclim., 1938, 49: 89-92.—Lebedev, i). 1>. IVjews of pediatrists concerning further development ot sanatorium and climatotherapeutic aid to children] Pedia- try, Moskva, 1940, No. 9, 22.—Le Noir. Sur les renseigne- ments k fournir par les stations climatiques en vue de leur classement en stations de cure pour tuberculeux et en stations ?™X ogiature; loi du 28 aout 1936- Bull- Acad, med., Par., 1939, 3. s6r 121: 776-9.—Leva, J. Ueber die Diiit an Kuror- ten, speziell in Tarasp. Arch. Verdauungskr., 1928, 42: i TodahJ- E. IPlans of buildings for the children's colony] Sven. lak. tidn., 1938, 35: 2079-84.— Lockhart. L. P. 5«"i£ry aA, »»hfalth resort- J- State M., Lond., 1937, 45: 358-bb. Also Med. Off., Lond., 1937, 57: 189-91 —--- ^f^Jn d ■' & Person, A. L. Industry and the health resort. Med. Press & Circ, Lond., 1937, 194: 366-75—Lorie. I. Uie Organisation der Krankenernilhrung in den russischen Kurorten. Zschr. wiss. Baderk., 1928-29 3: 162-5—Mark HEALTH RESORT 197 HEALTH RESORT E van Strassenanlage und Staubbeseitigung mit besonderer Rucksicht auf die Kurorte. Ibid., 1926-27 1: 548-51.— Messerli, F. M. Vingt-cinq ans de controle medical a la cure preventive de Vidy-Plage, Lausanne. Rev. m6d. Suisse rom., 1937 57: 827-36.—Mottram, V. H. The dietician and the public health resort. Med. Press & Circ, Lond., 1936, 192: 509-12 —Nilsen, E. A. [Organization of health resorts in Uzbekistan] J. profil. subtrop. klin. med., Tashkent, 1934, 4: 21-6—Ostermann. Zur Frage der sogenannten Mittel- standskuren. Zschr. wiss. Baderk., 1927-28, 2: 304-9.— Pfannenstiel, W. Aufgaben des Hygienikers im Kurort. Balneologe 1934 1: 269-73.—Resort and rural sanitation. Annual Rep. Michigan Dep. Health, 1939-40, 68: 35.— Ronge. H. Diatetik im Kurort. Med. Welt, 1938, 12: 629- 32.—Schaffer, H. Die gesundheitsschadlichen Wirkungen der Staubinhalation und die Bekampfung der Staub- und Rauch- plage in den Kurorten. Zschr. wiss. Baderk., 1927-28, 2: 623-30 —Slawik, E. Zum Ausbau der Erholungsfursorge. Med. Klin., BerL, 1937, 33: 57-60.—Straub, H. Die Be- kampfung der Typhusgefahr in Kur- und Badeorten. Zschr. wiss Baderk., 1927-28, 2: 99-107.—Vamossy, Z. [Role of hospitals at health resorts] Orv. hetil., 1937, 81: 1090-3 — Zimmermann, O. E. Zur Diatversorgung in Kurorten. V\ ien. klin. Wschr., 1939, 52: 771-5. --- Therapeutical value, and indications. See also Child, Health service; Convalescence. Scheck, E. *Die Beurteilung des Erholungs- erfolges in der Erholungsfursorge und seine Abhangigkeit von verschiedenen Faktoren; 12 Jahre Erfahrungen am Kindererholungsheim Homburg-Saar. 31p. 20#cm. Bonn, 1938. Zavadsky, N. A. [Health resort cure in northern climate] lllp. 2iy2cm. Leningr., 1935. Andreev, I. D., & Zavadovsky, N. A. [Health resort treat- ment in northern cUmate] In Kurort lech, uslov. sever, klim. (Zavadovsky, N. A.) Leningr., 1935, 6-22.—Benderek, I. [Balneotherapeutic aspect of geography and geopsychic phenomena of our health resorts] Gyogyaszat, 1939, 79: 311-3.—Bogdanov, A. A. [Analysis of counter-indications for treatment of patients at the Sochi-Matsesta health resort] Sovet. med., 1940, No. 12, 23.—Briining, H. Ueber die Be- deutung des Kurortaufenthaltes im Kindesalter. Deut. med. Wschr., 1933. 59: 483-5. ------ Ueber die Bedeutung der Kurorte des Harzes fur das Kindesalter. Miinch. med. Wschr., 1934, 81: 1052-5.—Brunn, von. Kinderlandverschickung, besonders vom Standpunkt des Schularztes. Vertrauensarzt, 1934, 2: 269-71.—Bublichenko, L. I. [Treatment of gyne- cological affections at the Tskhaltubo health resort] Kazan. med. J., 1939, 35: No. 2-3, 72-6.—Casaubon, A. Les Eaux- Bonnes, station d'enfants; enfants lymphatiques porteurs d'affections du cavum et des voies respiratoires inferieures; importance des etablissements specialises pour recevoir les enfants non accompagn6s. Gaz. mid. France, Par., 1938, 45: dim 31-4.—Clayton, F. Medicine at health resorts. J. R. San. Inst., 1935-36, 56: 479-83.—Danishevsky, G. M., Georgievsky, S. I., & Egorov, A. P. [Certain experimental data on the effect of health resorts on the constitution] Ter. arkh., 1935, 13: 11-24.—Diffre, H. La cure d'exercice de l'enfant dans les stations hydrominerales et climatiques. Presse therm, dim., 1940, 81: 29-32.—Dmitrieva, N. M. [Results and perspectives of sanatorium-chmatotherapeutic aid to children; general characteristics of the sanatorium- chmatotherapeutic network for children] Pediatna, Moskva 1940, No. 9, 15-21.—Fiirst, T. Indikationsstellung und Erfoigskontrolle der Erholungsfursorge fiir Kinder und Jugend- liche. Klin. Wschr., 1934, 13: 1614-9.—Gigon, A. Bemerkun- gen und Anregungen zur Kurorttherapie. Schweiz. med. Wschr., 1934, 64: 122.—Grossman, J. L. [General indications and counter-indications for health resort treatment] Feldsher, Moskva, 1938, No. 5, 52-9.—Haeberlin, C. Ueber die deut- schen Kurorte in ihrer Bedeutung fur die Erhaltung der Volks- gesundheit und fur Krankheitsvorbeugung. Prakt. Arzt, 1934, n. F., 19: 179; 203.—H6raud, R. L'Sducation et 1 in- struction au preventorium. Gaz. med. France, 1937, 44: No. 11, enf., 22.—Isbert, H. Gedanken iiber die Verschickung von Kindern in Kurorte. Kinderarztl. Prax., 1934, 5: 24-32.— Jacobsen, H. [Health resorts and medical treatment] Hos- pitalstidende, 1938, 81: [Jydsk med. selsk. forh ] 135-40 — Karchikian, S. I. [Indications and counter-indications tor treatment of patients at the Kislovodsk Sanitarium] Tr. Acad. mil. med. Kiroff, 1935, 4: 199-210.—Kaufmann, B. Ueber die Wirkung eines vierzehntiigigen Aufenthaltes in einem Erholungsheim auf das Blutbild. Zschr. klin. Med., 1926, 103: 694-702.—Kerkendzhia, N. E. [Effect of climatic factors of the sanatorium Bakuriani on health and physical development of children of pre-school age] Pediatna, Moskva, 1940, No 9 73-5.—Kisel, A. A. [Health resorts for children] Ibid., 1938, No. 9, 137.—Klare, K. Grundsatzhches zur Verschickung von Kindern in Heilstatten. Med. Klin., Berl., 1934, 30: 1188.—Krivoglaz, B. A. [Therapeutic factors of the Zheleznovodsk health resort] Vrach. delo, 1939, 21: 435-40.— .Kupferle, L. Die Rontgendiagnostik und ihre Bedeutung in der Kurortbehandlung. Balneologe, 1934, 1: 15-9 —Lebedev, D. D. Indications and counter-indications for sending children to sanatoriums] Pediatria, Moskva, 1937, No. 9, 83-90.— Lugt, H., Lakeman, P., & Lubsen, N. [Investigations on the effect of artificial heliotherapy in a vacation resort] Ned. tschr. geneesk., 1939, 83: 5349-56.—Merklen, L., Diffre, H., & Christophe, H. La cure individuelle d'exercice au Pare d'en- fants de La Bourboule. Presse therm, dim., 1940, 81: 32-46.— Merklen, L., & Grandpierre, R. La cure d'exercice dans les stations thermales et climatiques. Ibid., 5.—Oldemeyer, E. Anzeigen und Gegenanzeigen zum Heilverfahren und zur Erholungskur. Munch, med. Wschr., 1938, 85: 881-5.— Panick, C. Erfahrungen bei Begutachtung der Erholungs- fursorge der Krankenkassen und ihrer Erfolge. Vertrauens- arzt, 1935, 3: 28-31.—Repnikov, N. M. [A plea for more attention to health resorts] Vopr. kurort., 1941, No. 2, 1-4.— Reus, K. Polypragmatische Behandlung erholungsbediirftiger und kranklicher Kinder. Deut. med. Wschr., 1935, 61: 801.— Rommel, O. Aerztliche Richtlinien fiir die Gesundheits-, Erholungs- und Heilfursorge fiir deutsche Kinder. Miinch. med. Wschr., 1936, 83: 433-6.—Scheinkman, S. S. [On health resorts for children] Sovet. pediat., 1936, No. 6, 107- 10.—Schwalbe, J. Ruhe in Kurorten. Deut. med. Wschr., 1926, 52: 1177-9.—Seng, H. Gedanken zu der Frage: Seelische Krankenbehandlung im Kurort. Ibid., 1936, 62: 429-31.— Shklovsky, J. [Late beneficial results from treatment at health- resorts] Vrach. delo, 1928, 11: 967-71.—Smith, H. G. The influence of nature on health. J. R. San. Inst., 1935-36, 56: 304-8.—Sreznevsky, V. V. [Results of comparative study of the therapeutic significance of the natural factors of the health resort of Sestroretsk] In Kurort, lech, uslov. sever, klim. (Zavadsky, N. A.) Leningr., 1935, 47-52.—Strauss, H. Kur- orte und Kurmittel. Zschr. ges. phys. Ther., 1923, 27: 47-9.— Tichy, H. Therapie mit Leibesubungen und sportarztliche Tatigkeit im Kurort. Zschr. wiss. Baderk., 1927-28, 2: 333-7.—Tobias, E. Zur Frage der Behandlung der Patienten in Kurorten. Deut. med. Wschr., 1926, 52: 1309.—Vogt, H. Seelische Heilfaktoren im Kurort. Klin. Wschr., 1935, 14: 420.------Ueber Entsendungsbehandlung im Kindesalter. Med. Welt, 1937, 11: 574-6— Wallace, A. W. The modern health resort; an appraisal of its possibilities. J. Am. M. Ass., 1936, 107: 419-21.—Wilk, L. Van der [On the sending of weak children to the colony houses] Tegen de tuberculose, 1939 35: 81-95. HEALTH shoe digest. Bost., Mass., v. 1-2, No. 9, 1935-37. Continued as Health shoes. HEALTH shoes. Bost., Mass., v.2-3, Xo. 10- No. 6, 1937-38. Formerly Health shoe digest. HEALTH survey. See also Group, Health and health survey; also under names of cities, and countries; also Morbidity, Statistics. Cox, R. L. National health in the life in- surance mirror. 12p. 8° N. Y., 1921. Emerson, H. Public health diagnosis. 31p. 8? Chic, 1927. Batt, W. R. The sanitary index; a method of measuring public health work. Pennsylvania Health Bull., 1916, No. 78, 1-27, 9 ch.—Beet Growers Association cooperates for third year in X-ray examinations of Mexican field workers. Michigan Pub. Health, 1941, 29: 46.—Brooke, G. E. A dyscratic index, a suggestion for a new method of feeling the public-health pulse of towns or nations. J. State M., Lond., 1923, 31: 183-6.—Campbell, C. R. Public health examinations. Eclect. M. J., 1935, 95: 142-5.—Collins, S. D. Frequency of health examinations in 9,000 families, based on nation-wide periodic canvasses, 1928-1931. Pub. Health Rep., Wash., 1934, 49: 321-46.—Community (A) sickness survey. J. Am. M. Ass., 1915 65: 1939.—Daranyi, G. [Establishment of institutes for health survey] Orv. hetil., 1938, 82: 1-3.—Emerso r, W. R. P. The dentist and health diagnosis. Dent. Cosmos, 1930, 72: 1147-50.—Emery, V. M. Value of disease surveys to the community. Hospitals, 1940, 14: No. 4, 80-2.—Enescu, M., & Arteni, I. [Indices of health; comparative study of the inquiry applied in the rural districts and cities of Roumania] Rev. st. med., Bucur., 1940, 29: 1-68.— Evers. Sind wir heute gesunder als unsere Grosseltern? Fortsch. Med., 1934, 52- 1069-72.—First facts from the national health survey. Health Off., Wash., 1938, 2: 479-85.—Gegenbauer, V. Ueber Gesundheitsstatistik. Wien. med. Wschr., 1937, 87: 481; 514.—Goldwater, S. S. A plea for sickness surveys. Mod. Hosp., 1917, 8: 270.—Habs, H., & Simon, O. Ueber den Wert systematischer Untersuchungen an Jugendlichen. Deut. med. Wschr., 1934, 60: 1806-8.—Hamilton health survey. Ohio Pub. Health J., 1920, 11: 61-4.— Hazemann, R. H. Le recueil d'indices sanitaires instrument d'administration. Ann. hyg., Par., 1940, n. ser., 18: 73-99.—Kappes. Untersuchungen iiber den Gesundheitszustand badischer Sozialbeamtinnen im Juli 1928. Zschr. Schulgesundh., 1929, 42: 7-10.—Leger. Sur l'index paludeen, l'index filarien, la tuberculose et la try- panosomiase humaine. Ann. hyg. med. col., Par., 1914, 17: 77-81.—Lewis, D. M. The sanitary index. Am. J. Pub. Health, 1923, 13: 649-53.—Malespine, E. Hygiene et cadastre. HEALTH SURVEY 19S HEART Ann. hyg., Par.. li»3S. n. ser., 16: 34-42.- Meerkov, A. N. [Indexes of health for children and adolescents] Sovet. pediat., 193."., No. 5, 72-5.- Mi>airi. K. A method of investigation of the nation's health. Japan M. World, 1924, 4: 198-202 — Morison, F. H. A plea foi a health census. Med. Off., Lond., 1919, 21: 123; 131.—New (The) health survey. J. Am. M. Ass 1935, 105: 1127.—Newton, M. M. Making group studies of diseases. BuU. Am. Coll. Surgeons, 1939, 24: 213 — Notable (A) health survey. Lancet, Lond., 1934, 2: 568.— Pampana. E. J. (ill indici di sanita. Attual. med., 1937, 2: 141 -8 Perrott. G. St. J.. & Griffin, H. C. An inventory of the serious disabilities of the urban relief population. Q. Bull. Milbnnk Mem. Fund, 1936, 14: 213-41.—Pohlen, K. Die Aufstellung einer Gesundheifsstatistik und eines Gesundheits- index in der Fiirsorge. Gesundhfiirs. Kindesalt., 1933, 8: 128-30.—Reed, L. J. Procedures for handling statistical information in small health areas. Papers Health Work. Conf. Tennessee, 1938, 10: 3.5-9.—Roesle, E. Die Feststellung des Gesundheitszustands einer Bevolkerung. Arch, sozial Hyg., 1932, 7: 373-80.—Spence, J. C, & Charles, I. A. Investigation into the health and nutrition of certain of the children of Newcastle upon Tvne. Annual Rep. Med. Off. Health, N. Castle, 1933, App. A, 3-17.—Stocks, P. Health indices for greatei London and New York, 1931-40. Brit. M. J., 1941, 2: 96-8. — Winslow. C. E. A. The health survey as a social instrument. Proc. Nat. Conf. Social Work, 1930, 57: 163-72. Also Hosp. Social Serv., 1930, 22: 362-9. HEALTHY (The) home quarterly. Athol, Mass., v.28-31, 1928-32. Incomplete. HEALY, Romeyn J[ames] 1907- ♦Anal- gesia in obstetrics [Marquette Univ.] 35p. 8? Wauwatosa, Wis., 1932. Typewritten. HEALY, William, 1869- The individual delinquent; a text-book of diagnosis and prog- nosis for all concerned in understanding offenders. xvi, 830p. pl. ch. 8? Bost., Little, Brown & Co., 1915. Mental conflicts and misconduct, xi, ? Lond., K. Paul [et al.] 1919. Personality in formation and action. ° \. Y., W. W. Norton [1938] & ALPER, Benedict Solomon. Criminal vouth and the Borstal system, vi. 251p. 21%cm X. Y., Commonwealth Fund, 1941. HEALY, William, & BRONNER, Augusta F. Delinquents and criminals, their making and unmaking; studies in two American cities, viii, 2 1. 317p. 8? N. Y., Marmillan Co., 1926. —■— New light on delinquency and its treat- ment; results of a research conducted for the Institute of Human Relations, Yale University. 2. print, vii, 1226p. diagr. 8? New Haven, Yale Univ. Press [1937] HEAPS, William James. The perfect man. 79p. 8? X. Y., Xeale Pub. Co., 1918. HEARD, Allen George, 1888-1926. Obituary. J. Am. M. Ass.. 1926. 86: 570. HEARD, Gerald, 1889- Pain, sex and time; a new outlook on evolution and the future of man [2. ed.] xxii, 301p. 22/2cm. N. Y., Harper & brothers [1939] HEARING. See Audition. HEARING aid. See Deaf, Apparatus. HEARLE, Eric, & TWINN, C. R. Mosquito control in Canada. 4p. 8? Ottawa, 1930. Forms No. 62, Circ. Canada Dep. Agr. HEARST (The) medical papyrus; hieratic text in 17 facsimile plates in collotype, with intro- duction and vocabulary, by George A. Reisner 4 p. 1. 48p. 17 facs. sq. fol. ' Lpz., J. C* Hinrichs, 1905. HEART. Lond., v.7-16, 1918-33. Continued in Clinical science. HEART. See also Angiology; Cardiology; Cardiovascular system; Endocardium; Heart auricle; Heart- beat; Heart function; Heart muscle; Heart nerves; Heart-sac; Heart valve; Heart ven- tricle; also such heading as Aorta; Blood circula- tion; Mediastinum, &c. Wilson, R. M. The hearts of man. I73p. 8? Lond., 1918. Human (The) heart. Lancet, Lond.. 1937, 2: 695. -King, J. T., jr. The normal heart. In (\clop. Med. (Piersol-Bortz) Phila., 1939, 3: 775-85- McGehoe, E. ('. The heart. Ken- tucky M. J., 1935, 33:451. ---- Abnormity. See also Acardiacus; Cardiovascular system, Abnormity; Heart disease, congenital; Heart failure, congenital; also under specific names of cardiac structures as Pulmonary valve, Abnor- mity, &c. Linzbach, A. J. *Ueber eine seltene Herz- missbildung. 47p. 22cm. Bonn, 1936. Osterwald, G. *Ein Beitrag zur kongenitalen Missbildung des Herzens unter besonderer Berucksichtigung von Stenose und Atresie im linken Herzen. 23p. 8? Gott., 1925. Roediger, O. *Zur Kasuistik angeborener Missbildungen des Herzens und der Aorta. 26p. 8? Tiib., 1928. Sinzinger, J. *Ein kasuistischer Beitrag zur Lehre von den Missbildungen des Herzens [Munchen] 28p. S? Pfarrkirchen, 1928. Steger, W. *Variabilitat und Missbildung im Schweineherzen [Zurich] 24p. 8? Weimar, 1927. Also Anat. Anz., 1927, 63: Abbott, M. E. Congenital cardiac abnormalities. In Cyclop. Med. (Piersol-Bortz) Phila., 1939, 3: 605-20. Also in Diagn. Treat. Cardiovasc. Dis. (Stroud, W. D.) Phila., 1940, 1: 14-41.—Apert, Gamier, P., & Vilde. Malformation cardia- que et malformation verWbrale associ^es. Bull. Soc. pediat. Paris, 1932, 30: 333.—Ariel, M. B. Ein seltener Fall von ange- borenem Herzfehler bei einem Neugeborenen. Virchows Arch., 1930, 277: 501-6— Armand-Delille, Lhermitte, J., & Lesobre, R. Ramollissement h6morragique d'origine veineuse chez un enfant atteint de malformations cardiaques. Rev. neur., Par., 1936, 66: 754-9.—Babonneix, L., & Horeau, J. Malformation cardiaque. Bull. Soc. pediat. Paris, 1939, 37: 347-52.— Banssillon & Joly. Malformations cardiaques chez le nouveau- ni. Bull. Soc. obst. gyn. Paris, 1936, 25: 485.—Beccari, E. Una curiosa anomalia asservata nei cuore isolato di rana. Boll. Soc. ital. biol. sper., 1935, 10: 227-30.—Bigot & Boumard. Malformations congenitales du cceur chez une fillette de 11 ans. Arch. med. Angers, 1927, 31: 81-5.—Bisiarina, V. P. [Two rare cases of cardiac defect in children] Pediatria, Moskva, 1937, No. 7, 97-9.—Blackhall-Morison, A. Cardiac malforma- tion with vascular anomalies. J. Anat., Lond., 1927-28, 62: 227-31.------& Shaw, E. H. Cardiac and genito-urinary anomalies in the same subject. Ibid., 1919-20, 54: 163-5, pl — Boyd, G. I. Anomalous heart. Ibid., 1937-38, 72: 299, pl — Bredt, H. Die Missbildungen des menschlichen Herzens. Erg. allg Path., 1936, 30: 77-182.—Brodsky T. Congenital abnor- malities of the heart; a description of 2 uncommon varieties. Med. J. Australia, 1939, 1: 583-5- Bullard, J. F. Anomalous heart in a calf. J. Am. Vet. M. Ass., 1935, 87: 577-9.—Butka, H. E. Congenital heart defects; with report of an unusual case. California West M., 1928, 28:497 9.— Cassano. C. Contributo alia conoscenza delle malformazioni cardiache. Diagnosi, 1927, 7: 41-53— Chown, B., & Schwalm, F. G. Congenital abnor- mality of the heart. Am. J. Dis. Child., 1936, 52: 1427-9 — Ciuffini, P. Contributo clinico ed anatomo-patologico alio studio delle malformazioni cardiache congenite in individui adulti. Cuore & circol., 1938, 22: 125-48.—Coombs, C. F. Cardiovascular disease from a clinical standpoint; congenital malformations of the heart. Clin. J.. Lond., 1933, 62: 10-2 — Evans, J. G. A congenital heart deformity. J. Kansas M. boc, 1936, 37: 193; 207.—Fujimura, S. Zwei Falle von Herz- anomahen. Jap. J. M. Sc, 1941, 9: Abstr. Anat.. 114 — Gardere, C, & Viallier, J. Malformation cardiaque congenitale avec grosse hypertrophic du coeur chez un nourrisson. Lyon med., 1938, 162: 205-8.—Gaspar, I. Two of the rarer congenital anomalies of the heart. Am J. Path., 1929, 5: 285-93 2 pl.— u ile'cP"* & Devos> A. Un cas de malformation cardiaque. Bull. Soc. gyn. obst. Paris, 1939, 28: 188.—Gibson. S. Con- genital defects of the heart. Am. J. Dis. Child., 1934, 48: 704- b.—-Com, L. W. A congenital malformed heart in the dog. J. Am. Vet. M. Ass., 1932, 81: 546— Hammond. W. S. A rare HEART 199 HEART cardiac anomaly. Anat. Rec, 1937-38, 70: 67-70, pl.— Hemsath, F. A., Greenberg, M., & Shain, J. H. Congenital cardiac anomalies in infants; report of 5 cases: accessory ventricle; tetralogy of Fallot with right aortic arch and redundant left ductus arteriosus; tetralogy of Fallot with anomalous band in right auricle; complete transposition of arterial trunks and double defect of ventricular septum. Am. J. Dis. Child., 1936, 51: 1356-71.—Heraux, A. Malformations congenitales du cceur chetf un nourrisson. Ann. anat. path., Par., 1926, 3: 746 —Hopeful outlook for babies born with heart defect. Science News Lett., 1940, 37: 371.—Ischii, T. Beitrag zur Kenntnis der Entwicklungsanomalie des Herzens. J. Orient. M Dairen, 1927, 6: 5.—Kaliebe, H. Entwicklungsstorungen des Herzens. Med. Welt, 1930, 4: 294.—Kizilova, A. L., & Zolotovskaia, V. A. [Case of congenital defect of the heart] Klin, med., Moskva, 1937, 15: 638-42.—Lafont, M. Anomalia congenita de corazon con cornage respiratorio. Arch, med., Madr., 1935. 38: 522-5.—Lahm, W. Seltene kongenitale Herzmissbildung. Zbl. allg. Path., 1927-28, 41: 149-53 — Lascano, J. C, & Valenzuela, J. R. Rara malformaci6n cardfaca en un recien nacido con sindrome de cuello corto. Prensa mid. argent., 1934, 21: 1847-61.------Sindrome clinico de cuello corto y muv rara malformaci6n cardfaca en un recien nacido. Bol. Soc. obst. gin. B. Aires, 1934, 13: 155-80.—Ledenyi, J. [Two cases of abnormal development of the heart] Bratisl. lek. listy, 1933, 13: 219-32.—Leinati, L. Su di un caso raro di malformazione del cuore in un puledro (nota anatomica) Clin. vet,. Milano, 1929, 52: 6-10, pl.—Leoncini, F. Mancanza di vitality per rara malformazione cardiaca. Arch, antrop. crim., Tor., 1930, 50: Suppl., 1242-56.—Levy, Morlot & Francois. Malformations cardiaques chez le nouveau-ne. Bull. Soc. obst. gyn. Paris, 1927, 16: 485.—Lhermitte, J., Lereboullet, J., & Kaplan. Ramolissement hemorragipare d'origine nerveuse chez un enfant, atteint de malformations cardiaques. Rev. neur., Par., 1936, 65: 305-12.—Malavasi, F. Sopra alcune anomaliein sede endocardica; tendini aberranti; variazioni nella involuzione della valvola del foro ovale. Cuore & circol., 1933, 17:287- 306.—Marciniak, T. Ueber Missbildungen des Herzens bei einem Neugeborenen mit Monobrachie. Zschr. Anat. Entw., 1937, 107: 620-32.—Margolis. R. I. [Congenital heart defects in children] Pediatria, Moskva, 1940, No. 6, 62-6.— Martinez, G. N., & Llambias, J. Sobre un caso de malformaci6n congenita del coraz6n acompanado de arterio-esclerosis de la arteria pulmonar. Prensa mid. argent., 1929-30, 16: 101-10.— Mindlin, S., & Estol Baleztena, M. Malformaciones cong6nitas del coraz6n. Ibid., 1937, 24: 1251-67.—Monserrat, J. L. Compleja y rara malformaci6n congenita cardfaca. Rev. As. mid. argent., 1937, 51: 337-41.—Ngai, S. K. Congenital anomaly of tjie heart; report of a case, with embryological discussion. Am. J. Path., 1935, 11: 309-21, 3 pl.—Olafson, P. Congenital cardiac anomalies in animals. J. Techn. Meth., Toronto, 1939, 19: 129-34.—Perez Ara, A. Contribuci6n al estudio de las anomalias congenitas del coraz6n. Rev. med. cir. Habana, 1931, 36: 657-82.—Perotti, D. Questione di vitality per una rara malformazione congenita del cuore. Boll. Soc. med. cbir., Pavia, 1927, n. ser., 2: 275-80, pl.—Perry, C. B. Congenital anomalies of the heart in elementary school children. Arch. Dis. Childh., Lond., 1931, 6: 265-72—Pezzi, C, & Agostoni, G. Controllo anatomico di un vizio congenito nei cuore precedentemente illustrato. Atti Soc. lombard. sc. med., 1927, 16: 194-8, pl.—Philpott, N. W. Relative incidence of congenital cardiac anomalies in Montreal hospitals. J. Techn. Meth., Toronto, 1936, No. 15, 96-9.—Rannels, H. W., & Propst, J. H. The incidence of congenital cardiac anomalies found at autopsies performed in the hospital of the University of Pennsylvania. Ibid., 1937, 17: 113-8. Also repr.—Sakaki, J. Ueber einen Fall ausserst seltener Herzmissbildung. Tr. Soc. path, jap., 1934, 24: 462-4.—Schneider, H. Eine seltene Herzmissbildung. Anat. Anz., 1939, 88: 251-60.—Schramm, H. G. Schwere Herzmissbildungen bei alteren Individuen. Beitr. path. Anat., 1929, 82: 153-62.—Schwanen, H. Zwei seltene Herzmissbildungen. Zschr. Geburtsh. Gyn., 1933, 106: 416-28.—Stolz, J. Trois cas rares de malformation cardiaques. Rev. fr. pediat,, 1928, 4: 515-21.—Thomas, H. W. Congenital cardiac malformations. J. Techn. Meth., Toronto, 1941, No. 21, 58-70.—Trillat & Revol. Malformation cardiaque chez un nouveau-ne ayant v6cu 48 heures. Bull. Soc. obst. gyn. Paris, 1935, 24: 56-9. Also Nourrisson, 1935, 23: 316-9.—Von Wedel, H., & Toth, B. J. Rare congenital cardiac anomaly. New Rochelle Hosp. M. Staff Bull., N. Y., 1938, 1: 60-8.— Voron & Lyonnet, R. Malformation congenitale du coeur chez un nouveau ni. Bull. Soc. obst. gyn. Paris, 1933, 22: 187-9.— Willis, R. A. A developmental abnormality of a lizard's heart. J. Anat., Lond., 1930-31, 65: 137-9.—Zimmermann, A. A. A rare cardiac anomaly of a human fetus. Anat. Rec, 1934, 58: 245-8. ---- Abnormity: Bi- and triloculate heart. See Heart chambers, Abnormity. ---- Abnormity: Diagnosis. Zirkel, H. *Beitrag zur Differentialdiagnose angeborener Herzfehler. 32p. 23cm. Lpz., 1937. Arkoussky, J. I. Contribution k l'etude du roentgenodiag- nostic des lesions congenitales du coeur. Ann. roentg., Par., 1926-27, 2: 254-70.—Attinger, E. Zur Diagnostik der ange- borenen Herzfehler. Zschr. Kreislaufforsch., 1941, 33: 84-7.— Kliachko, V. R. [Diagnosis of congenital heart defects] Vrach. delo, 1938, 20: 137-40.—Kogan, B. A., & Dubogrei. I. M. [Electrocardiographic investigations in congenital defects of the heart] Ibid., 99-105.— Laubry, C, Soulie, P., & Marre, P. Valeur indicatrice des dissociations auriculo-ventriculaires pour le diagnostic des malformations congenitales du coeur. Arch. mal. coeur, 1939, 32: 449-63.—Mannheimer, E. The electro- cardiogram of congenital heart defects. Acta paediat., Upps., 1939, 24: 128-36 [Discussion] 159-64.—Reid, W. D. The diagnosis of congenital defects of the heart. N. England J. M., 1931, 204: 764, tab.—Sheftel, I. N. [Diagnosis and treat- ment of congenital anomalies of the heart] In Recueil Stra- jesko (Bogomoletz, A.) Kiev, 1935, 979-82.—Willius, F. A. Clinic on a congenital cardiac defect in the absence of physical findings. Proc Mayo Clin., 1941, 16: 395. ---- Abnormity: Double heart. Goss, C. M. Double hearts produced experimentally in rat embryos. J. Exp. Zool., 1935, 72: 33-49, pl.—Kisch, B. Demonstration einer scheinbaren Doppelbildung des Herzens beim Frosch. Verh. Deut. Ges. Kreislaufforsch., 1929, pt 2, 105-7. Also Zschr. Kreislaufforsch., 1929, 21: 489.—Wolff, E. Realisation experimentale de monstres k coeur double. C. rend. Soc. biol., 1933, 112: 1090-2. ---- Abnormity: Eisenmenger's tetralogy. See also Pulmonary artery, Dilatation. Baumgartner, E. A., & Abbott, M. E. Interventricular septal defect with dextroposition of aorta and dilatation of the pulmonary artery (Eisenmenger complex) terminating by cerebral abscess; report of a case observed during life, pre- senting impaired conduction, and paralysis of recurrent laryn- geal nerve from pressure of hypertrophied pulmonary conus. Am. J. M. Sc, 1929, 177: 639-47. Also repr.—Lev, M. Te- tralogy of Eisenmenger. Arch. Path., Chic, 1940, 29: 866.— Rosedale, R. S. Interventricular septal defect, dextroposition of aorta, and dilatation of pulmonary artery; report of a case with structural pathogenesis. Am. J. Path., 1935, 11: 333-41, 2 pl.—Saphir, O., & Lev, M. The tetralogy of Eisenmenger. Am. Heart J., 1941, 21: 31-46.—Stewart. H. L., & Crawford, B. L. Congenital heart disease with pulmonary arteritis; interventricular septal defect, dextroposition of the aorta and dilatation of the pulmonary artery. Am. J. Path., 1933, 9: 637-48, 3 pl. Also repr.— Talley. J. E., & Fowler, K. Tet- ralogy of Fallot (Eisemenger type) with hypoplasia of the dextroposed aorta. Am. J. M. Sc, 1936, 191: 618-26, 2 pl.— Weinstein, S. A congenital perforate interventricular septum of the heart accompanied by a shortened medial tricuspid leaflet and a dilated pulmonary artery with 2 cusps. Tr. Chicago Path. Soc, 1923-26, 12: 279-82. ---- Abnormity: Fallot's tetralogy. See also Pulmonary artery, Stenosis. Adt, A. J. *Ueber einen Fall von Atresie des Pulmonalostiums bei Transposition der grossen Gefasse mit Septumdefekt des Herzens und partiellem Situs inversus. 14p. 8? Wiirzb., 1932. Blackford, L. M. Tetralogy of Fallot; cUnical report of a case. Arch. Int. M., 1930, 45: 631-40, pl.—Dreyfuss, M. Complete transposition of arterial trunks with stenosis of aortic arch, patent ductus Botalli, open foramen ovale, and defect of interventricular septum. Rep. Surg. Staff Woman Hosp. State N. York, 1925-28, 6: 289-92. Also J. Techn. Meth., Toronto, 1929, No. 12, 187.—Fallot, E. L. A. Con- tribution to the pathologic anatomy of morbus caeruleus, cardiac cyanosis, transl. by L. Morissette. In Cardiac Classics (Willius, F. A.) S. Louis, 1941, 689.—Feldman, W. M., & Snook, S. G. A congenital cardiac pentad; Fallot's so-called tetralogy together with a common inter-ventricular orifice. Brit. J. Child. Dis., 1938, 35: 183-90.— Fleury, J. Tetrade de Fallot sans cyanose. Arch. mal. coeur, 1937, 30: 121-32.— Gravinghoff, W. Anfallsweise Cyanose bei angeborenem Herzfehler (Pulmonalstenose mit Ventrikelseptumdefekt und einfacher Transposition der Aorta) Mschr. Kindern., 1927, 35: 237-51.—Grishman, A., Steinberg, M. F., & Sussman, M L Tetralogy of Fallot; contrast visualization of heart and great'vessels. Radiology, 1941, 37: 178-80.—Herndon, R. F Vass, A., & Donovan, J. J. The tetralogy of Fallot; terminal sepsis with crossed emboli. Am. Heart J., 1939, 17: 553-60.— Kremer, M. Blood gas figures in a case of Fallot s tetralogy. J Physiol Lond., 1934, 80: Proc, 26.—Liboro, A., & Hilario, J S Tetralogy of Fallot: report of a case with necropsy. 5. Philippine Islands M. Ass., 1933, 13: 541-51.-MarchbankS, H. E. Fallot's tetralogy. J. Kansas M. Soc, 1933, 34: 434- 6 —Pescatore, J. A., Wolffe, J. B., & Digilio, V. A. Tetralogy of Fallot; correlation of clinical, roentgenologic, and post- mortem findings. Am. Heart J., 1939 17: 489-93.-Rothstadt, L E The tetralogy of Fallot. Melbourne Hosp. Clin. Kep., 1939 10- 105-12. pl.—Segall, H. N. A case of tetralogy of Fallot: clinicopathological observations; quantitative studies of circulation rate and the right-to-left shunt. Am. Heart J., 1933 8- 628-49.—Smetana, H. Seltene Herzmissbildung (sogenannter Septumdefekt, Transposition der grossen Gefass- no HEART HEART Stnmme. Atresie des rechten venosen Ostiums) Zschr. Kreis- laufforsch., 1929, 21: 513-23.— Talbotl, J. H.. Coombs. F. S. [et al.j A record case of the tetralogy of Fallot, with comments on metabolic and pathologic studies. Am. Heart J., 1941, 22: 754-77.—Todtenhaupt, W. Kongenitaler Herzfehler (Pul- monalstenose, Ventrikelseptumdefekt und Transpositio aortae) und Ei\ thro< jtose. Deut. Arch. klin. Med., 1926, 154: 79-84.— Velasco Blanco. L.. & Monferini, E. Consideraciones sobre un caso de anomalia congenita cardfaca; posible tetra- logia de Fallot. Arch, lat, amer. pediat.., B. Air., 1929, 23: 930-6.—Volini, I. F., & Flazman. N. Tetralogy of Fallot; report of a case in a man who lived to his fortv-first year. J. Am. M. Ass., 1938, 111: 2000-3. Also repr.—White, P. D. The tetralogy of Fallot; report of a case in a noted physician, who lived to his sixtieth year. Ibid., 1929, 92: 787-91. ---- Abnormity: Hypoplasia. Rosbach, H. *Das kleine Herz und organische Krankheiten. 19p. 8° Koln, 1936. Garrison, R. E. Transposition of the viscera with asympto- matic, arrested cardiac development; a case report. Wisconsin M. J., 1939, 38: 882.—Kushiner, J. I. A case of rudimentary congenital heart in newborn. Am. J. Obst., 1931, 22: 647-9.— Seuderling, Y. [Roentgenological observations on the small heart] Duodecim, Helsinki, 1938, 54: 227-45. ---- Abnormity: Morbus coeruleus. See also Cyanosis, congenital; Foramen ovale, patent; Heart, Abnormity: Fallot's tetralogy; Heart chambers, Abnormity; Pulmonary artery, Stenosis, &c. Adomavicius, J. [Morbus coeruleus] Medicina, Kaunas, 1939. 20: 359 67.—Arcangeli, U. Osservazioni in una malatii di vizio congeniti) di cuore con ciano.si. Cuoie it circol., 1929, 13: 48.5-91.—Armand-Delille, P., Tiffeneau, R.. & Gysin, O. La diminution de la vitesse de la sedimentation globulaire dans la maladie bleue, cyanose congenitale; causes de ce phi- nomene. C. rend. Soc. biol., 1937, 126: 1164-7.—Bierent, P. Cyanose congenitale due k une malformation du coeur et des troncs arteriels de la base. J. sc. med. Lille, 1925,43:405-13.— Biihler, K., it Zettel, H. Klinische Beobachtungen iiber Morbus coeruleus. Deut. med. Wschr., 1939, 65: 1196-8 — Buinewitsch, K. Leber Morbus coeruleus; Myocarditis cyanotica und Sclerosis pulmonalis, Cyanosis congenita und angeborene Herzfehler. Med. Welt, 1939, 13: 662-6.— Bussy & Cros. Les lesions du fond d'oeil dans la maladie bleue. Lyon med., 1927, 139: 140.—Cossio, P., & Berconsky, J. La cyanose des malformations congenitales du coeur. Arch. mal. coeur, 1935, 28: 19-46.—Grenet, H. Les affections congenitales du coeur; notions sommaires sur le developpe- ment du coeur; etude clinique; la maladie bleue. In his Conf. clin. med. inf., Par., 1933, 2. ser., 149-72.—Hochsinger, K. Ueber das Zvanose-Problem bei den angeborenen Herzfehlern der Fruhkindheit. Wien. med. Wschr., 1937, 87: 1295; pas- sim.—Lavrinovich, N. A. |Diagnosis and treatment of morbus coeruleus] Klin, med., Moskva. 1939, 17: No. 2-3, 124-9.— Leech, C. B. Symptoms in congenital lesions of the heart that permit venous shunting. Am. J. Dis. Child., 1932, 43: 1086-91. Also repr.—Lindeboom, G. A. [Morbus coeruleus with open ventricular septum] Ned. tschr. geneesk., 1939, 83: 5555-8.—McGuire, J., & Goldman, F. Apparent increased velocity of blood flow in cases of congenital heart disease with septal defects having right-to-left shunt. Am. Heart J., 1937, 14: 230-5.—Oliveira Soares. Um caso de doenca azul. Poly- technia, Lisb., 1906, 2: 46-52, 3 pl.—Pijoan, M., & Berard, M. Une nouvelle methode de diagnostic des communications cardiaques arterio-veineuses dans les cardiopathies congeni- tales. C. rend. Soc. biol., 1936, 122: 411-3.—Shapiro. M. J., & Simons, J. H. Cyanotic congenital heart disease and full term pregnancy. Minnesota M., 1934, 17: 600.-—Sigal, A. M. [Diagnosis of congenital cardiac defect* accompanied by cyanosis] Vrach. gaz., 1930, 34: 772-4.—Taussig, H. B. Diagnosis of congenital malformations of the heart in infants with persistent cyanosis. Am. J. Dis. Child., 1938, 56: 939.— Weill-Halle, B., Koang & Aubert. Deux observations de cyanose congenitale avec malformation grave du coeur. Bull. Soc. pediat. Paris, 1932, 30: 403. ---- Abnormity, multiple. See also Heart, Blood vessels: Abnormity; Heart, Displacement. Fdter, A. * Ueber einen Fall seltener, kom- plizierter Herzmissbildung [Zurich] p.245-85 23cm. Lpz., 1937. Also Morph. Jahrb., 1938, 81: Tziwanopoulos, S. *Ueber eine multiple Herzmissbildung. bestehend in offenem Foramen ovale, Stenose der Aorta und aneurysmatisch erweitertem Ductus arteriosus (Botalli) 23p 8? Miinch., 1929. Abbott. M. E., & Moffatt, W. Mirror-picture dextrocardia, complicated l\ mitral aplasia and pulmonary hypoplasia, with great hypertrophy of the transposed right chambers. Canad. M. Ass. J., 1929, 20: 611 6. Aschoff. I.. Zur Frage des partiellen Situs inversus am Herzen und del Transposition der grossen Gefasse. Arch. Entwmech., 1929, 116: 267-77.— Atkinson, W. J., jr. Dean. J. I,, [et al.] A multiple nnomah of the human heart and pulmonary veins. Anat. Rec, 1940, 78: 383-8.—Bog Nolo. I.. Terceira contribuicao ao estudo das malformacoes rarissimas do coraciio; sinus reuniens pareial- mente persistente (agenesia do seio coronario) grave defeito do septo interatrial, defeito subaortico do septo interventricu- lar, (foramen (itrio-ventricular comum persistente) em um individuo de cinco dias. Fol. med., Rio, 1940, 21: 303-14.— Brule, M., & Gilbert-Dreyfus. Malformations congenitales multiples du coeur avec atresie tricuspidienne et retrecissemeiit de l'artere pulmonaire; sutvie de 18 ans. Bull. Soc. med. hop. Paris, 1926, 3. ser., 50: 963-7.—Capovani, L. Di un raro caso di malformazione congenita del cuore e dei grossi vasi. Pathologica, Genova, 1927, 19: 497-512.- Cassoute, Poinso & Morel. Anomalie congenitale complexe du coeur; atresie tricuspidienne complete avec communication interventricu- laire et interauriculaire; artere pulmonaire retrecie naissant du ventricule gauche. Marseille med., 1931, 68: 306-9.—Dolgopol, V. B. Cor pseudotriloculare with atresia of the mitral and aortic ostia. Bull. Internat. Ass. M. Mus., Montreal, 1934, No. 13, 100-6.—Dreyfuss, M. Complete transposition of arterial trunks with stenosis of aortic arch, patent ductus Botalli, open foramen ovale, and defect of interventricular septum. Proc. N. York Path. Soc, 1925, 25: 114-7.—Eakin, W. W., & Abbott, M. E. Stenosis of the pulmonary conus at the lower bulbar orifice (conus a separate chamber) and closed interventricular septum; with 2 illustrative cases; case 1; With dextroposition of aorta and aneurysm of interventricular septum, all fetal passages closed; case 2: With patent foramen ovale and subacute infective endocarditis. Am. J. M. Sc, 1933, 186: 860-70, 4 pl.—Goltman, D. W., & Stern, N. S. Congenital heart disease; report of a case of dextroposition, persistence of an early stage of embryonic development of the heart, persistent truncus arteriosus, abnormal systemic and pulmonic veins, and subdiaphragmatic situs inversus. Am. Heart J., 1939, 18: 176-87.—Gravinghoff & Liebig. Ange- borenes isolieites Rechtsherz ohne Kammertausch mit Pulmo- nalatresie. Zschr. Kreislaufforsch., 1931, 23: 2-12.—Gunn, F. D., & Dieckmann, J. M. Malformations of the heart in- cluding 2 cases with common atrioventricular canal and septum defects and one with defect of the atrial septum (cor trilo- culare biventriculosum) Am. J. Path., 1927, 3: 595-615, 3 pl.—Holder, E. C, & Pick, J. Congenital heart disease; atresia of tricuspid orifice, hypoplasia of the right ventricle. septal defects and patent ductus arteriosus. J. Techn. Meth., Toronto, 1939, 19: 135-47. Klein. H. Ueber einen seltenen Fall von Herzmissbildung mit iiidimentarer Entwicklung dee rechten Ventrikels und Defekt der Tricuspidalklappen. Vir- chows Arch., 1938, 301: 1-16.—Kurtz, C. M., Sprague. H. B.. A White, P. D. Congenital heart disease; interventricular septal defects with associated anomalies in a series of 3 cases examined postmortem, and a living patient 48 years old with cyanosis and clubbing of the fingers. Am. Heart J., 1927-28, 3: 77-90.— Lambert, R. A. Anomaly of heart and aorta; multiple defects with stenosis of aortic arch and pulmonary artery becoming descending aorta. Bull. Internat. Ass. M. Mus., Montreal, 1922, 8: 177-83.—Linzbach. A. J. Ueber eine gleichzeitige Missbildung der drei Scheidewande des Herzens. Frankf. Zschr. Path., 1936, 50: 218-30.—Martin, C. P. A case of congenital abnormality of the heart with apparently an un- usual abnormality of the great vessels. J. Anat., Lond., 1930- 31, 65: 395-8.—Miller, A. J. Congenital heart disease with partial situs inversus, absence of inferior vena cava, and other anomalies. Am. J. Path., 1925, 1: 467-76, 4 pl.—Morlot, R. Absence congenitale d'orifice aortique, agenesie du ventricule gauche et de l'aorte ascendante; circulation gen6rale fournie par l'artere pulmonaire. Bull. Soc. anat. Paris, 1923, 93: 273-5—Read, W. T., & Krumbhaar, E. B. Eight cases of congenital heart disease (3 cases of Fallot's tetralogy; 2 cases of complete transposition of great vessels; 2 anomalies of the semilunar cusps, 1 with coarctation of the aorta; 1 case of premature closure of the foramen ovale) Med Clin N. America, 1932, 16: 229-42.—Scatamacchia, E. Un caso raro di anomalie di sviluppo cardiopolmonari. Zacchia, 1938, 2 ser. 2: 126-39.—Schranz, D. [Complicated abnormity of the heart in a child of Wi years] Orv. hetil., 1933, 77: 1003 — Simer [Defects of the heart and abnormal blood vessels] Bratisl. lek. listy, 1928, 8: 212-20.—Soster, A. Difettoso sviluppo del setto interauricolare del cuore; aplasia dellarco aortico; arterite deformante dell'arteria polmonare con estesa trombosi del suo ramo sinistro. Gazz. osp., 1923, 44: 73-5.—Tedeschi, C. Sopra un caso di atresia dell'ostio atnoventncolare sinistro con mancanza della parte membrana- cea del setto interventricolare e con ematonoduli Arch. ital. anal pat, 1936, 7: scritti, 71-88.—Velasco Blanco, L., & Monferini, E. Consideraciones sobre un caso de vicio cardlaco congenito multiple. Arch. amer. med., B. Air., 1931, 7: 35-9. ---- Abnormity: Pathogenesis. Bredt, H. Formdeutung und Entstehung des missgebildeten menschlichen Herzens. Virchows Arch., 1935-36, 296: 114- o/-—Doerr, W. Zwei weitere Falle von Herzmissbildungen; ol«n f?.oag zu bPltzers Phylogenetischer Theorie. Ibid., 1938, 3011: 0O8-80.—Hoffmann, H. Ueber drei Falle von Herzmiss- bildungen; zugleich ein Beitrag uber den Wert der Spitzerschen HEART 201 HEART Theorie zur Erklarung des Entstehungsmechanismus von Herz- missbildungen. Zbl. allg. Path., 1932-33, 56: 321-7—Moncke- berg, J. G. Herzmissbildungen und deren Folgen fiir den Kreislauf. In Handb. norm. path. Physiol. (A. Bethe, G. von Bergman [et al.]) Berl., 1926, 7: T. 1, 114-31.—Pernkopf, E. Erwiderung zu den Ausfiihrungen Spitzers iiber meine Kritik der phylogenetischen Theorie der Herzmissbildungen. Zschr. ges. Aiint,, 1. Abt., 1927, 84: 549-54.------& Wirtinger, W. Das Wesen der Transposition im Gebiete des Herzens, ein Versuch der Erklarung auf entwicklungsgeschichtlicher Grund- lage. Virchows Arch., 1935, 295: 143-74.—Spitzer, A. Zur Kritik der phylogenetischen Theorie der normalen und miss- bildeten Herzarchitektur. Zschr. ges. Anat., 1. Abt., 1927, 84: 30-130.------Versuch einer Erklarung des Wurmschen Falles von korrigierter Transposition der grossen Herzgefasse (ein Beitrag zur phylogenetischen Theorie der Herzmissbil- dungen) Virchows Arch., 1927, 263: 142-58. ------ Be- merkungen zu Aschoffs und Kiungs Kritik der stammesgeschicht- lichen Theorie der Transpositionsmissbildungen des Herzens. Ibid., 1933, 289: 247-63.—Stohr, G. Malformations of the heart of the new-born; congenital lesions suggestive of an inflammatory origin. Arch. Path., Chic, 1934, 17: 311-23.— Szepsenwol,-J. L'asymetrie normale et inverse du coeur chez les embrvonsdepoulet omphalocephales produits experimentale- ment. C. rend. Soc. bioi., 1933, 113: 1383-5.------Les conditions embryologiques qui menent k la formation d'un coeur unique ou double, ainsi que d'elles qui causent l'asymetrie normale ou inverse de l'organe pulsatile chez des embryons de poulet omphalocephales produits experimentalement. Arch. anat., Strasb., 1934, 17: 307-70.—Wurm, H. Angeborener Herzfehler mit korrigierter Transposition der grossen Gefasse; ein Beitrag zur Anwendung der Theorie A. Spitzers. Virchows Arch., 1927, 263: 123-41. --- Ageing. See also Heart, Development; Heart, Hygiene; Heart function; Heart muscle, Ageing; Heart rate. Casteran, R. *Le cceur senile (etude clinique) 188p. 8? Par., 1930. Muller, B. *Le coeur vasculaire chez le vieillard. 176p. 25cm. Lyon, 1938. Antal, E. [The heart in adolescence] Magv. rontg. kozl., 1938, 12: 1-8.—Campbell, S. B. B. The heart in middle age. Ulster M. J., 1936, 5: 229-33.—Chaika, E. I. [Senile anatomy of the heart] In Starost (Kiev. Akad. nauk USSR Inst. klin. fiziol.) Kiev, 1940, 89-95.—Crossetti, L., Randone, G., & Schiavina, M. Osservazioni sul cuore senile. Gior. Accad. med. Torino, 1938, 101: 244-50.—DeBuys, L. R., & Samuel, E. C. Roentgenographs observations on the growth of the heart. Tr. Am. Pediat. Soc, 1925, 37: 19.—Dogliotti, G. C. Ricerche sulla anatomia microscopica del cuore deil'uomo; trasformazioni strutturali del cuore nella senescenza. Boll. Soc. ital. biol. sper., 1930, 5: 294-6.—Duthoit, A., Warembourg, H., & Pinchart. Etude radiologique du coeur senile. Paris med., 1938, 109: 97-100.—Dutton, W. F. The senile heart. Clin. M. & S., 1934, 41: 70-2.—Garcia Pintos, S. El coraz6n senil. Arch. urug. med., 1933, 2: 835-51.—Guassardo, G. Studi sul cuore dell'immaturo; ricerche elettrocardiografiche, tele- radiografiche e rilievi anatomo-dimensionali. Riv. clin. pediat., 1940, 38: 321-52.—Hergloz, J. [Evaluation of cardiac changes in childhood] Orv. hetil., 1935, 79: 645.—Herz (Das) eines Hundertzweiundzwanzigjahrigen. Umschau, 1936, 40: 971.— Kiser, E. F. The senile heart. J. Indiana M. Ass., 1935, 28: 580; 614.—Laubry, C, Routier, D., & Moussoir. J. Le cceur senile. Monde med., 1927, 38: 745-59.—Medawar, P. B. The growth, growth energy, and ageing of the chicken's heart. Proc. R. Soc, Lond., 1940-41, ser. B, 129: 332-55.—Miller, A. M., & Perkins, O. C. Elastic tissue of the heart m advancing age. Am. J. Anat., 1927, 39: 205-13, 2 pl.—Miller, S. R. Vour heart at 50. Baltimore Health News, 1935, 12: 132-5.— Murphey, E. E. The senile heart. J. M. Ass. Georgia, 1928, 17: 389-92.—Musser, J. H. The ageing heart. Illinois M. J., 1941, 79: 510-6.—Orsos, F. [Role of the coronaries in ageing of the heart] Orvoskepzes, 1937, 27: 569-90, 28 pl.—Paliard, F., & Muller, B. Recherches anatomo-cliniques et eiectro- cardiographiques sur le coeur vasculaire chez le vieillard. Lyon med., 1940, 164: 289; 305.—Shuman, J. W., sr. The senescing heart. Med. Rec, N. Y., 1940, 151: 411-3.—Sprague, H. B. The clinical and electrocardiographic findings in the aging heart. Med. Ann. District of Columbia, 1941, 10: 49-56.— Vaz de Mello, M. O coracao em biotypologia infantil. Brasil med., 1931, 45: 487-91.—Wendkos, M. H. Geriatrics and the cardiologist. Med. Soc Rep., Scranton, 1941, 35: No. 5.13-5 — Willison, G. W. The heart in middle life. J. Indiana M. Ass., 1941, 34: 57-60.—Willius, F. A., & Smith, H. L. Further observations on the heart in old age; a postmortem study of 381 patients aged 70 years or more. Am. Heart J., 1932, 8: 170-81. ---- Anatomy. See also Heart (subheadings: Histology, Measurement, Shape, Size, Structure, Weight) Walmsley, T. The heart. 152p. 8? Lond., 1929. Belowa, M. Fossula cordis nervina. Zschr. ges. Anat 1. Abt., 1928, 86: 517-31.—Drennen, M. R. Some studies on the anatomy of the heart. Med. J. S. Africa, 1926-27, 22: 3-5.— Fetzer, H. Die Lage des rechten Vorhofes und des rechten Ventnkels beim stehenden Menschen. Fortsch. Rontgenstrahl., 1932, 46: 29-36.—Pace, D. Problemi di anatomia del cuore, visiti da un medico. Rass. internaz. clin. ter., 1926, 7: 73-97, 2 P1-—Pelayo Roncal y Rico, M. Algunos descubrimientos sobre anatomia y fisiologfa del corazon. Rev. espan. med. cir. guerra, 1941, 7: 153-84.—Petinto, M. P. de. Investigaciones ana- tomicas sobre la estructura del corazon. Progr. clin., Madr., 1917, 10: 248-68, 2 pl. ---- Anatomy, comparative. See also Heart, Cartilage; Heart, Structure; also names of animals. Angst, J. *Das Herz des Hausschafes (Ovis aries L.) p.209-52. 8? Zur., 1928. Also Morph. Jahrb., 1928, 59: Benninghoff, A. Das Herz. p.467-556. 8? Berl., 1933. In Handb. vergl. Anat. (Bolk, L., & Goeppert, E.) Berl., 1931-33, 6: Bischofberger, W. *Das Herz des Hasen (Lepus timidus Schreb.) [Zurich] 34p. 8? [Oberegg] 1929. Egli, P. *Das Herz von Cavia cobaya [Schreb.] 28p. 8? Zur., 1927. Fabian, H. *Vergleichend anatomische Stu- dien an Chelonierherzen (nebst Hauptgefassen) und Versuch ihrer physiologischen Deutung [Bern] 46p. 8? Jena, 1913. Gschwend, T. *Das Herz des Wildschweines; Beitrag zur Anatomie von Sus scrofa L. und zum Domestikationsproblem [Zurich] 42p. 8? [Weimar] 1931. Also Anat. Anz., 1931, 72: Jansen, L. *Der Bau des Herzens von Ciconia atra. 27p. 25cm. Munster, 1938. Kern, A. *Das Vogelherz; Untersuchungen an Gallus domesticus Briss. 55p. 8? [Ziir.] 1926. Also Morph. Jahrb., 1926, 56: Maurer, J. *Beitrag zur normalen und pathologischen Anatomie des Equidenherzens. 29p. 8? Zur., 1926. Schrodter, R. *Untersuchungen zur Ana- tomie des Herzens der straussartigen Vogel; das Herz von Rhea. 36p. 30cm. Miinst., 1937. Severin, A. *Das Herz von Macropus rufus Desm. 25p. 8? Miinst., 1935. Stiefel, K. *Das Herz des melanotischen Seidenhuhns [Zurich] 29p. 8? Weimar, 1926. Also Anat. Anz., 1926, 61: Waldmeier, E. *Das Rehherz (Cervus capreolus L.) p.567-98. 8? Ziir., 1928. Also Morph. Jahrb., 1928. 59: Adams, W. E. A contribution to the anatomy of the avian heart as seen in the kiwi (Apteryx australis) and the yellow- crested penguin (Megadyptes antipodum) Proc. Univ. Otago M. School., 1939, 16: No. 4, 417-41, pl.—Bodrossy, L. [Data on the comparative anatomy of the giraffe's heart] Allatorv. lap., 1938, 61: 331.—Brunet, R., & Jullien, A. Des caracteristi- ques architecturales du coeur chez 2 lamellibranches marins: Ostrea edulis L. et Venus gallina L. C. rend. Acad, sc, 1936, 202: 1945-7.------De l'architecture du coeur chez le peigne. C. rend. Soc. biol., 1936, 122: 1104-6.—Herrmann, G. The hearts of wild animals in captivity. Proc. Soc. Exp. Biol., N Y 1929-30,27:1042-4.—Hopkins, A. E. Accessory hearts in'the oyster, Ostrea gigas. Biol. Bull., 1934, 67: 346-55.— Kern, A. Das Kaninchenherz. Morph. Jahrb., 1927, 58: 125-52—King, R. L., Burwell, C. S., & White, P. D. Some notes on the anatomy of the elephant's heart. Am. Heart J., 1938, 16: 734-43.—Kochi, T. Anatomical and histological observations of the heart of Tachypleus tridentatus. Okayama igakkai zasshi, 1935, 47: 992.—Korner, F. Das Herz der Schwanzlurche. Jena. Zschr. Naturwiss., 1937, 71: 35-178, pl —Marees van Swinderen, J. W. de [The reptilian heart] Ned. tschr. geneesk., 1929, 73: 397.—Rodrigues, A., & Sousa Pereira. Estudos sobre a topografia do coracao do cao. Arq. anat., 1936, 17: 499-507.—Simic, V. Zur Anatomie des Carni- vorenherzens (Untersuchungen am Feliden, Hyaniden, Caniden, Procyoniden und Musteliden) Morph. Jahrb., 1938, 82: 499- 536—Zhedenov, V. N. [On the morphology of the heart in the HEART 202 HEART higher mammals and nun] Arch. russ. anat., 1941, 27: 38- 53.— Ziillich, R. Ueber das Herz von Salamandra maculosa Morph. .lahrb., 1930, 65: 178-228. ---- Aneurysm. See under Heart muscle. ---- Apex. See also Heartbeat. Carillon, P. *Importance de decubitus lateral gauche dans l'examen clinique de la pointe de coeur. 60p. 8? Par., 1929. Franklin, K. J. Rotatory movements of the apex of the exposed mammalian heart. J. Physiol., Lond., 1939, 96: 164- 7.—Gaudin, C. Determination pratique de Tangle de dispari- tion de la pointe de cceur. Arch, electr. med., 1928, 38: 144- 6.—Hanson, H. B. Bifid apex of the heart of a guinea-pig. Tr. Chicago Path. Soc, 1930, 13: 228-30.—Mainoldi, P. Sulla determinazione della regione apicale del cuore all'orto- diagrafia. Riv. radiol., 1930, 2: Suppl., 67-9.—Miranda Gallino, M. La determinaci6n orto-diagrafica de la punta del corazon. Prensa med. argent., 1928-29, 15: 1498. Also Tr. clin. Escudero, B. Air., 1930, 4: 555-7.—Pezzi, C. Deter- minazione della punta del cuore suH'ortodiagramma. Atti Soc. lombard. sc. med., 1926, 14: 158-02. Also Cuore & circol., 1926, 10: 89-98.—Rouslacroix, A., & Emperaire, R. Procede pratique d'apprAciation radioscopique de Tangle de disparition de la pointe du coeur. C. rend. Soc. biol., 1929, 101: 584-6.— Stankovic, R., & Arnoljevic, V. L'angle de rotation de la pointe du cceur k la suite dune surpression dans Themithorax gauche. Arch. mal. cceur, 1929, 22: 76-80. ---- Arrhythmia. See Heart arrhythmia. ---- artificial. See Heart, Model. ---- Atrium. See Heart auricle. ---- Auscultation. See Heart sounds. ---- Autopsy. See also Heart, Death; Heart, Histology. Cohen, P. Congenital hearts at autopsy. N. York State J. M., 1931, 31: 896.—Fishback, D. B. A new instrument for determining cardiac condition at autopsy. J. Lab. Clin. M., 1936-37, 22: 952.—Genty, M. Coeurs conserves, perdus ou retrouves. Progr. med., Par., 1939, Suppl., 33-5.—Gross, L., & Leslie, E. Paraffin infiltration of hearts; a permanent method for preservation. Am. Heart J., 1931, 6: 665-71.—Kadletz, M. Zur Sektioustechnik des Herzens. Anat. Anz., 1927-28, 64: 401-8.—Vermes, E. Zur Sektionstechnik des Herzens. Ibid., 1925-26. 60: 395-405.—Waterston, D., Orr, J., & Cappell, D. F. Sir James Mackenzie's heart; with an account of his clinical history and notes on the pathological histology. In Cardiac Classics (Willius, F. A.) S. Louis, 1941, 794-800. ---- Block. See Heart block. ---- Blood pressure. See Blood pressure, Regional differences: Heart; Heart chambers, Blood pressure. ---- Blood vessels. See also Aorta; Caval veins; Coronary vessels; Ductus arteriosus; Pulmonary artery. Chaperon, R. Contribution a l'etude anato- moradiologique des vaisseaux de la base du coeur vus deface. 62p. 8? Par., 1921. Beck, C. S. Blood supply to the heart; experimental con- siderations Tr. Nat. Tuberc. Ass., N. Y., 1940, 36: 132.— Bel let, S. Nourishment of the heart by channels other than the coronary arteries. In Cyclop. Med. (Piersol-Bortz) Phila 1939, 3: 769-75. Also In Diagn. Treat. Cardiovasc. Dis (Stroud. W. D.) Phila., 1940, 1: 463-71.—Czmor, S., & Urbanyi, E. Arteriographische Beobachtungen an den Herzgefiissen Fortsch. Rontgenstrahl., 1939, 60: 57-64.—Delattre, A. Les ar teres cardiaques accessoires. J. sc. med. Lille, 1928, 46: pt 2, 137-45.—Delherm, L., Devois, A., & Rulliere. Etude des gros vaisseaux de la base du coeur par les methodes radi- ologiques d'examen in coupe. J. radiol. electr., 1939, 23: 145-56.—Dobyns, B. M. Note on an artery of the moderator band. Anat. Rec., 1936, 66: 397-400 —Fazzari, L. Sulla' fine irrorazione del cuore umano. Riv. pat sper., 1937, 19: 52-69.—Fracassi. H. Pro\ ecto de nomenelat ura de las ai Unas del coraz6n. Prensa med. argent.. M'39. 26: 40-5.- Mill, I. G. W., & Rothberger, C. J. Uebei die folgen der Unter- bindung der Septumartei ie des Hundherzens im kurzen Tier- versuch. Zschr. ges. exp. Med., 1934, 93: 420-40.—Horta, R. A import&ncia para a clinica da M-gunda art£ria septal anterior do coracao. Med. contenip., Lisb., 1938, 56: 291-7.— Iagnov, Z. Sur la dualite primordiale des vemes du coeur. Ann. anat. path., Par., 1938, 15: 53-8.—Kisch. B. Die ZentralwUlste im Conus arteriosus der Selachier. Anat. Anz., 1930, 70: 462-70.—Kiser, W. J. An experimental study of the effects of constriction of the great vessels of the heart. Surg. Gyn. Obst., 1935. 61: 765-88.—Loeper, M., & Soulie, P. La nutri- tion du cceur. Rev. med. fr., 1932, 13: 321-31.—Melo Adriao. Sur l'injection des capillaires cardiaques par le sinus coronarien. Ann. anat. path., Par., 1938, 15: 559-63.—Pfuhl, W. Der Einfluss des Lungensogs auf die makroskopischeu und mikro- skopischen Strukturverhaltnisse der herznahen Venen und auf die Lymphgefasse. Aerztl. Fortbild. Bad Nauheim, 1938, 14: 136-48.—Rodrigues, A., Carvalho, R. de, & Sousa Pereira. Irrigacao sanguinea e linfatica do coracao do cfio. Arq. anat., 1936, 17: 317-27.—Tsuchiya, S. Das Arteriensystem des Herzens bei den japanischen Zwillingsfeten. Okajimas fol. anat., 1938-39, 17: 165-98. ------ Das Venensystem des Herzens bei den japanischen Zwillingsfeten. Ibid., 199-225.— Zummo, C. Modificazioni indotte da stimoli periferici sulla respirazione periodica della rana dopo legatura del cuore. Boll. Soc. ital. biol. sper., 1934, 9: 345. ---- Blood vessels: Abnormity. See also Heart, Abnormity; Heart, Displace- ment; also under names of blood vessels. Matuszczyk, H. *Morphologische Betrach- tungen iiber einen Fall von Herzmissbildung: Aortenventrikel [Munchen] 25p. 21cm. Wiirzb., 1938. Alfandary, I. Sur la persistance du sinus veineux chez le fetus humain. Arch, anat., Strasb., 1927, 7: 65-77, 1 pl — Anderson, N. A., & Sano, M. E. Aortic atresia with hypo- plasia of the left ventricle. Am. J. Dis. Child., 1941, 62: 629-33.—Beau, A., & Weber, P. Etude anatomique avec considerations embryologiques sur un cas de disposition anormale des vaisseaux de la base du cceur. Arch, anat., Strasb., 1932-33, 15: 63.—Davison, G. A case of congenital heart disease with single arterial trunk. J. Anat., Lond., 1934-35, 69: 423-6.—Engels, H. Herzmissbildung mit Ein- miinden der Vena pulmonalis in den rechten Herzvorhof (kritischer Beitrag zur Kenntnis der atypischen Miindungs- verhaltnisse dieser Vene) Frankf. Zschr. Path., 1935-36, 49: 206-13.—Grcifenstein, A. Seltene Anomalien der grossen Gefasse bei Missbildungen des Herzens. Virchows Arch., 1930-31, 279: 486-503.—Heitz, J. Dilatation congenitale de Taorte coexistant avec quatre valvules sigmoides et une ano- malie des coronaires; insuffisance valvulaire. Bull. Soc. anat. Paris, 1901, 76: 719.—Hu, C. H. Congenital malformation of heart with anomalous insertion of pulmonary veins, absence of spleen, situs inversus of abdominal viscera and other develop- mental errors; report of a case. Am. J. Path., 1929, 5: 389-96, 4 pl.—Hiilse, W. Beitrag zur Kenntnis der totalen Persistenz des Truncus arteriosus communis. Virchows Arch., 1918, 225: 16-23.—Jianu, I.. & Tovaru, S. [Study of valvular and arterial abnormities of the heart] Rev. st. med. Bucur., 1928, 17: 97-118.—Keith, A. Malformations of the bulbus cordis; an unrecognized division of the human heart. In Stud. Path., (Bulloch, W.) Aberdeen, 1906, 55-74.—Lawrence, T. W. P., & Nabarro, D. A case of congenital malformation of the heart, with abnormalities of abdominal viscera: absence of spleen, absence of hepatic section of inferior cava. J. Anat. Physiol., Lond., 1901-2, 36: 63-75— Manca, C. Sopra un caso di malformazioni multiple dei grossi vasi arteriosi del cuore; arco aortico destro, atresia dell'arteria polmonare e persistenza di un ramo anastomotico del plesso polmonare post-branchiale. Arch. ital. anat. pat., 1933, 4: 81.5-38.—Mildenberger, K. Ueber abnorme Einmiindung der Pulmonalvenen in das Herz und iiber das familiare Auftreten angeborener Herzfehler. Frankf. Zschr. Path., 1937-38, 51: 427-36.—Mottura, G. Sulla patogenesi delle stenosi del cono arterioso del cuore. Arch. sc. med., Tor., 1939, 67: 493-540.—Raeder, O. J. Un cas de malformation congenitale du cceur avec obliteration complete de l'artere pulmonaire. Bull. Soc. anat. Paris, 1922, 92: 236. Also J. Am. M. Ass., 1922, 79: 16.—Schierbeck, N. J. [Congenital malformation of the heart with aplasia and hvpo- plasia of the pulmonary artery] Ugeskr. laeger, 1933, 95: 107.5-8.—Shapiro, P. F. Truncus solitarius pulmonalis; a rare type of congenital cardiac anomaly. Arch. Path., Chic, 1930,10:671-6. Also repr.—Versari, R. Rara anomalia della valvola di Eustachio in uomo adulto con doppia vena cava supenore. Ricer. Lab. anat. norm. Univ. Roma, 1905-6, 11: 5-23, pl. ---- Blood vessels: Abnormity: Persistent truncus arteriosus. See also Aorta, Abnormities; Ductus arteriosus, I patent. HEART 203 HEART Wirth, A. *Ein Fall von totaler Persistenz des Truncus arteriosus communis. 32p. 8? Giessen, 1912. Almeida Toledo, P. J. de. Sobre um caso de provavel permanencia do canal arterial. Rev. med., S. Paulo, 1931-32, 16: 9-21, 4 pl.—Bokay, Z. [Case of truncus arteriosus com- munis persistens] Orv. hetil., 1914, 58: 39-41.—Dancourt & Bastien. Sur un cas de persistance du bulbe arteriel. Echo med. nord, 1935, 3. ser., 3: 445-7.—Graham, S., & Montgomery, G. L. Congenital malformation of heart; persistent truncus arteriosus. J. Techn. Meth., Toronto, 1938, 18: 97-100.— Humphreys, E. M. Truncus arteriosus communis persistens; criteria for identification of the common arterial trunk, with report of a case with four semilunar cusps. Arch. Path., Chic, 1932, 14: 671-700. Also repr.—Ingalls, N. W. Truncus arteriosus communis persistens. Anat. Rec, 1915, 10: 9—14.— Pezzi, C, & Agostoni, G. Considerations cliniques, anato- miques et radiologiques k propos d'un cas de maladie congenitale du coeur controiee a Tautopsie; persistance du tronc arteriel commun. Arch. mal. coeur, 1927, 21: 19-29.—Siegmund, H. Totale Persistenz des Truncus arteriosus communis (bei einer 33jahrigen Frau und einem neugeborenen Madchen) Zschr. Kreislaufforsch., 1928, 20: 65-73.—Zimmerman, H. M. A congenital anomaly of the heart; truncus arteriosus communis. Am. J. Path., 1927, 3: 617-21, 3 pl. --- Blood vessels: Abnormity: Transposition of arterial trunks. See also Heart, Abnormity (subdivisions); also Heart, Dextrocardia; Heart, Displacement (subdivisions) Hirsch, L. *Ueber eine Sonderform der Transposition der grossen Gefasse [Berlin] 30p. 8? Charlottenb., 1932. Schaefer, A. *Ueber Transposition der grossen arteriellen Gefasstamme des Herzens [Bonn] 30p. 8? Hamm, 1919. Steinegger, R. *Dreizehn Falle von Trans- position der grossen Herzarterienstamme [Zu- rich] 50p. 8? Stans, 1924. Baptista, B. V. Contribution k l'etude des anomalies du coeur; un cas de vraie transposition des arteres de la base du cceur. Ann. anat. path., Par., 1933, 10: 1212-5.—Cowen, S. O. An unusual type of congenital heart lesion, transposition of the arterial stems; complicated by cerebral abscess: a sym- posium. Melbourne Hosp. Clin. Rep., 1930, 1: 125-32.— Doerr, W. Zur Transposition der Herzschlagadern; ein kritischer Beitrag zur Lehre der Transpositionen. Virchows Arch., 1938-39, 303: 168-205.— Geipel, P. Weitere Beitrage zum Situs transversus und zur Lehre von den Transpositionen der grossen Gefasse des Herzens. Arch. Kinderh., 1902, 35: 112; 222.—Hamburger, L. P., jr. Congenital cardiac mal- formation presenting complete interruption of the isthmus aortae with transposition of the great arteries. Bull. Johns Hopkins Hosp., 1937, 61: 421-8.—Harris, J. S., & Farber, S. Transposition of the great cardiac vessels; with special reference to the phylogenetic theory of Spitzer. Arch. Path., Chic, 1939, 28: 427-502.—Hecko, I., & Vychytil, O. [Clinical and radiological diagnosis of transposition of the large cardiac vessels] Cas. lek. desk., 1933, 72: 676-81.—Hedinger, E. Transposition der grossen Gefasse bei rudimentarer linken Herzkammer bei einer 56 jahrigen Frau. Zbl. allg. Path., 1915, 26: 529-35.—Hickel, P. Pathogenie de la transposition vraie des arteres de la base du coeur. Bull. Soc. anat. Paris, 1922, 92: 294-309.— Homma, H. Ein Beitrag zur Erklarung der Transposition von Aorta und Arteria pulmonalis. Wien. klin. Wschr., 1923, 36: 810-2.—Jensen, G. Beitrag zu dem klinisch-radiologischen Bild der Transposition grosser Gefasse und zu der Theorie Spitzers von ihrer Entstehung. Frankf. Zschr. Path., 1932, 43: 545.—Kato, K. Congenital transposi- tion of cardiac vessels; a clinical and pathologic studv. Am. J. Dis. Child., 1930, 39: 363-85.—Madon, V., & Manca, C. Su di un caso di trasposizione vera dell'aorta e della polmonare; studio clinico, anatomopatologico ed embriogenetico. Cuore & circol., 1930, 14: 172-97. -Moore, R. A. Transposition of the great arterial trunks; report of a case. J. Techn. Meth., Toronto, 1929, No. 12, 184-6. --- Blood vessels: Surgery. See Heart, Surgery. ---- Blood vessels: Thebesian veins. See Coronary vessels, Veins, Thebesian. --- Bradycardia. See under Heart rate. ---- Cartilage. See also subheading Anatomy, comparative. Katschinsky, P. Die Herzknorpel des Pferdes. Arch. wiss. rakt. Tierh., 1924, 50: 84-90.—Matumoto, K. Beitrage zur Kenntnis der vergleichenden Anatomie des Herzknorpels Keijo J. M., 1938, 9: 114-69, 2 pl.—Zagorovsky, N. A. [Chon- droid tissue in the heart of the vertebrata] Russ. ark. anat., ---- Chambers. See Heart chambers. — Chemistry. See also Heart hormone; Heart muscle, Chem- istry. Blume, H. Chemische Untersuchungen iiber den Glyko- gengehalt und Gesamtkohlehydratgehalt des menschlichen Herzens. Beitr. path. Anat., 1934, 93: 20-35.—Fieschi, A., & Beltrametti, L. Ricerche sul chimismo cardiaco; ricerche com- parative sulla composizione chimica delle varie parti del cuore Boll. Soc. med. chir., Pavia, 1933, 47: 243-9.—Herrmann, G., Decherd, G. M., jr, & Oliver, T. Creatine content of human hearts. Proc. Soc. Exp. Biol., N. Y., 1936, 34: 827-9 — Ishihara, M., & Iwao, T. Ueber den Histamingehalt des Herzens. Arch. exp. Path., Lpz., 1937-38, 188: 110-3.— Komiyama, T. Untersuchungen zur Physiologie und Phar- makologie der Ph am Herzen. Ibid., 1929, 139: 100-19.— Loeper, M., Lesure, A., & de Seze, J. Variations regionales du soufre du coeur. C. rend. Soc. biol., 1930, 103: 322.—Loeper, M., Tonnet, J., & Lebert. Variations regionales des lipoides cardiaques. Ibid., 321.—Marti no. G. Sulla presenza di fos- fogeno nei cuore. Boll. Soc. ital. biol. sper., 1927, 2: 1019-22.— Wassermeyer, H. Chemische Untersuchungen menschlicher Herzen. Deut. Arch. klin. Med., 1934-35, 177: 573-99.— Zeehuisen, H. [Determination of potassium in the ashes of hearts of lower animals] Ned. tschr. geneesk., 1927, 71: 997- 9. ------ & Streef, G. M. Ueber die Konzentration radio- aktiver Atome in Kaltbluterherzen. Arch. ges. Physiol., 1926 215: 170-86. ---- Compression [and decompression] See also Heart dilatation; Heart sac (sub- headings: Hydropericardium; Pericarditis, Pres- sure, &c.) Allen, D. S., & Graham, E. A. Effects of pressure on the heart, with reference to the advisability of decompression of greatly enlarged hearts. Arch. Surg., 1929, 19: 1663-71.— Beck, C. S. Acute and chronic compression of the heart. Am. Heart J., 1937, 14: 515-25. ------ The compressed heart; physiology, clinical manifestations and operative treatment. In Libro de oro (M. R.Castex) B. Air., 1938, 2: 128-45. Also Med. Rec, Houston, 1939, 33: 881-90. Also Tr. Nat. Tuberc. Ass., N. Y., 1940, 36: 132. Also Surgery, 1941, 9: 329.— Hudson, W. A. Decompression of the heart (case report) J. Thorac Surg., 1931, 1: 149-53.—O'Shaughnessy, L. Cardiac decompression by mobilising the chest wall. Lancet, Lond., 1940, 1: 61-5.—Pisula, V. P. Chronic compression of the heart. Pennsylvania M. J., 1936-37, 40: 18-20.—Roberts, J. T., & Beck, C. S. The effect of chronic cardiac compression on the size of the heart muscle fibers. Am. Heart J., 1941, 22: 314- 20.—Yodice, A. Compression of the heart produced experi- mentally. Surg. Gyn. Obst., 1941, 73: 277-80. ---- Concussion. See under Heart, Injury. ---- Conductive system. See Heart conduction. ---- Cycle. See Heart function. ---- Death, and postmortem changes. See also Cadaver, Rigor; Heart, Autopsy; Heart, Resuscitation. Hung Te Chang, S. *Studies on rigor mortis of the heart. 30p. 8? [Chic, 111.] 1936. Sckell, J. *Die elektrokardiographischen Aufzeichnungen des sterbenden menschlichen Herzens. 32p. 8? Munch., 1926. Bisbini, B. Ricerche di elettrocardiografia sul cuore morente. Athena, Roma, 1932, 1: 163-74.—Brooks, C. Conduction and contraction of cardiac musculature in water rigor. J. Am. M. Ass., 1926, 87: 1195.—Dyrenfurth. Die Gasbildung im Leichenherzen. Deut. Zschr. gerichtl. Med., 1925-26, 6: 650.—Filip, L. Electrocardiogramme post mortem. Rev. med, est, 1929, 57: 393-8.—Fogelson, L. I. [Electrocardiog- raphy of a dying heart] Med. biol. J., Leningr., 1928, 4: 3- 14.—Hanson, J. F., Pruks, W. K., & Anderson, R. G. Electro- cardiographic studies of the dying human heart, with observa- tions on the intracardiac injection of epinephrine, report of 25 cases. Arch. Int. M., 1933, 51: 965-77.—Polstorff, F. Ueber postmortale Herzkontraktionen beim Menschen. Virchows HEART 204 HEART Arch., 1927, 263: 179 SS Simpson. V. E. The dying heart South. M. J., 1940, 30: 1200-8.— Sisto, P. Studio elettro- cardiografico sul cuore morente. Minerva med., Tor., 1920, 6: 1-9.- Smirnov. A. I. [On the terminal activitv of the heart] J. Physiol. USSR, 1941, 30: 504-13.- Turner. K. B. The mechanism of death of the human heart as recorded in the electrocardiogram. Am. Heart J., 1931, 6: 743-57. ---- Development. See also Heart conduction; Heart function, Development; Heart nerves; Heart sound, fetal. Rosedale, R. S. *Some aspects of the embryological development of the human heart, with especial reference to the endocardial cushions and the formation of the interventricular septum [Univ. Buffalo] 57 1. 4? Buffalo, N. Y., 1934. Barry, A. Development of the human heart. Rhode Island M. J., 1938, 21: 76-8.—Baudouin, M. La prehistoire du coeur. Biol, med., Par., 1927, 17: 179; 201.— Breham, W. The fetal heart. Ohio M. J., 1928, 24: 862-6.—Bremer, J. L. An inter- pretation of the development of the heart. Am. J. Anat., 1928, 42: 307-37, 5 pl.—Bruno, G. Studii sulla anatomia micro- scopiea del cuore; Taccrescimento in lunghezza dei segmenti cardiaei. Anat. Anz., 1933-34, 76: 129-48.—Davis, C. L. Development of the human heart from its first appearance to the stage found in embryos of 20 paired somites. Contr. Embryol. Carnegie Inst.. 1927, 19: No. 107. 245-84, 8 pl — Fernandez Taquechel, A. Embriologia del corazon. Vida nueva, Habana, 1934. 34: 280-4.--Nauck, E. T. Zur Kenntnis der Topogenese lb'- Hcizeu- und der Nu. phrenici. Morph. Jahrb., 1939, 83: 1 S2. Odgers, P. N. B. The formation of the venous valves, the foramen secundum and the septum secun- dum in the human heart. J. Anat., Lond., 1934-35, 69: 412- 22, 3 pl.- Romhanyi, G. [Embryology of the heart] Gyo- gyaszat, 1939, 79: 343.—Salotti, A. Su di un indice di sviluppo cardiaco individuale. Minerva med.. Tor., 1927, 7: 1213.— Saunders, J. B. deC. M. The development of i he heart. Mod. Concepts (aid. Dis., 1936. 5: 1. ■ ■ Schluter. H. F. The fetal heart. Tr. Pacific Coast Soc. Obst., 1930, 6: 109-16. Also West. J. Surg., 1937, 45: 71-8. ---- Development, comparative. liianrhi. G. Osservazioni sulla cosi detta gelatina cardiaca delTembrione di polio. Monit. zool. ital., 1939, 50: 116-22, pl.- Boerner-Patzelt, D. Studien iiber die Herzentwicklung bei der Knte. Zschr. mikr. anat. Forsch., 1931, 36: 399-411, pl.— Burlingame, P. I... .*. Long, J. A. The development of the heart in the rat. Univ California Tub., 193S 39. 43: Zolo., 249-320, 27 pl.- -Chun Chang. On the reaction of the endocardium to the blood ,-tieam in the embryonic heart, with special reference to the endocaidial thickenings in the atrioventricular canal and the bulbus cordis. Anat. Rec, 1932. 51: 253-65. Congdon, E. D., & Wang. H. W. The mechanical processes concerned in the format ion of i he differing types of aortic arches of the chick and the pig and in the divergent early development of their pulmonary arches. Am. J. Anat., 1926-27, 37: 499-520.— Copenhaver, W. M. Experiments on the development of the heart of Amblystoma punctatum. J. Exp. Zool., 1925-26, 43: 321-71.—Ehrich, W., & Cohn, A. E. Anatomical ontogeny; fowl; rabbit ; a study of the nuclei of the heart. Am. J. Anat., 1931, 49: 209-40.—Ekman, G. Experimentelle Untersuchungen iiber die fi iilieste Herzentwicklung bei Rana fusca. Arch. Entwmech., 1929, 116: 1. 1, 327-47.— Goerttler. Die Be- deutung der ventrolateralen Mesodermbezirke fiir die Herzan- lage der Amphibienkeime. Verh. Anat. Ges., 1928, 37: 132-9, pl.—Hyrnan, L. H. The metabolic gradients of vertebrate emhryos; the heart. Biol. Bull., 1927, 52: 39-48, 3 pl — Krainer, L. Zur Entwicklung der Herzschleife und Knickungs- falte bei Chalcides ocellatus. Morph. Jahrb., 1933, 72: 362- 78. — Narasimhamurti, N. The development and function of the heart and pericardium in Echinodermata. Proc. R. Soc, Lond., 1932. 109: ser. B.. 471-87, 2 pl.—Olivo, O. M. Diffe- renziazione morfologica e funziouale del miotomi e del cuore nell'embrione di polio. Gior. Accad. med. Torino, 1924, 4. ser., 30: 117. ------ Ueber die friihzeitige Determinierung der Herzanlage beim Huhnerembryo und deren histologische und physiologische Differenzierung in vitro. Verh. Anat. Ges., 1928, 37: 108-1S. 2 pl ------ Accrescimento ponderale e coefficiente mitotico dell'accrescimento nei cuore embrionale di polio incubato a temperatura inferiore alia normale. Boll. Soc. ital. biol. sper., 1930, 5: 882-4. —---- Accrescimento dei cuore in uccelli di mole corporea differente. Anat. Anz., 1932- 33, 75: 475-81.------& Slavich, E. Ricerche sulla velocity delTaccrescimento delle cellule e degli organi; accrescimento ponderale, coefficiente mitotico delTaccrescimento e durata della mitosi e delTintereineM nei cuore embrionale di polio Arch. Entwmech.. 1930, 121: 96-110.—Ota, T. Experimentelle Studien uber die Entstehung der Herz- und Gefasszellen bei den Amphibien. Jap. J. M. Sc, 1929-30, 2: Tr. Anat., 22.5-34, pl. ------ Experimentelle Studien iiber den Herzbildungs- bezirk an den Amphibieulai ven. Ibid., 235-42. pl. Umkehrungsversuch de- H< iziohre- bei den Amphibienlarven. Ibid.. 243-7, pl.------ Leber die partielle Elimination der Herzplatte und des Hiziohn, bei den Amphibien. Ibid 249-56, 2 pl.—Pagani, M. P. Puce che sullo sviluppo del cuore nei Coregonus lavaretus I. iiatio larianus Monti. Arch ital anat., 1935-36, 34: 359 75.-Porta, E. Sulla distribuzione topografica delle mitosi nei cuore di embrioni di polio nei primi due giorni di incubazione. Boll. Soc ital. biol. sper.. 1930, ,r>: S97-9. Also Monit. zool. ital., 1930 31, 41: Suppl., 211-3.- Schornstein, T. Beitrage zur Kenntnis der Herzentwicklung der Siiugetiere. Zschr. Kreislaufforsch., ] 931. 23: 633-42. -----Beitrage zur Kenntnis der Klappen- und Septenent- wicklung im venosen Abschnitt des Saugetierherzens (nacli Unter-uehuiicen am Schwein) Morph. Jahrb., 1932, 70: 217 71. Schwind, J. L. Situs cordis in parabiotic frog larvae. True. Soc Kxp. Biol., N. Y., 1937-38, 37: 116. Stohr, P., jr. Experimentelle Studien an embrvonalen Amphibienlierzen. Arch. Entwmech., 1927, 112: 696-738.------Neue experi- mentelle Ergebnisse zur Herzentwicklung bei Amphibien. Klin. Wschr., 1926, 5: 628; 1927, 6: 1681. Also Verh. Anat. Ges., 1926, 35: 151-4.—Tomono, K. Ueber die entwicklungs- geschichtlichen Lageveranderungen der einzelnen Herzab- schnitte bei Rana tagoi. Jap. J. M. Sc, 1941, 9: Proc. Anat., 16.—Waddington, C. H. The dependence of head curvature on the development of the heart in the chick embryo. J. Exp. Biol., Lond., 1937, 14: 229-31. ---- Dextrocardia. See also Heart, Abnormity; Viscera, Situs inversus. Schleckat, O. *Isolierte angeborene Dextro- kardie mit Inversion der Herzhohlen [Berlin] 12[>. S? Dresd., 1931. Also Zschr. Kreislaufforsch., 1931, 23: Wehner, H. * Angeborene Dextrokardie mit Transposition der grossen Gefasse [Leipzig] 27p. 8? Zeulenroda, 1935. Balcazar Rubio, M. Consideraciones acerea de un caso interesanle de dextrocardia con lieterotaxia. Siglo m6d., 193 1. 93: 316-50. —-Calandre. L., f i n anlnmi Medicina, Kaunas, 1940, 21: 105-17.—LeinofT. H. I). I >m , i nonpenetrating injuries of the heart. Ann. Int. M., 19 10 II, 14: 653--60.-I.evit, J. [On injuries of the heart] Cas. lek. cesk., 1939, 78: 1345-52.—Martinez, M. Heridas del corazon. Bol. Soc. cir. Chile, 1927, 5: 2-7.—Pina. P., & Martiarena, L. H. Heridas del corazon y del pericardio. Bol. Inst. clin. quir., B. Air., 1940, 16: 127-32.—Protopopov. S. P. [Combined injuries of the heart and diaphragm] Klin, med., Moskva, 1937, 15: 1032-5.—Semsroth, K., & Pool, E. Zur Heilung von Herzwunden. Frankf. Zschr. Path., 1926, 34: 451-9.—Sicard, A. Plaies du coeur. Rev. med. fr., 1939, 20: 373-8.—Tejerina Fotheringham, W. Herida de coraz6n. Rev. mid. Rosario, 1932, 22: 899-911.—Timoshenko.O. V. [Wounds of the heart.] Vest, khir., 1929, 18: 164-7.—Topchibashev, M. [Injuries to the heart] Ibid., 1930, 22: 128-32.—Tuohy, E. L., & Boman, P. G. Trauma to viscera from non-penetrating external injuries, with special reference to the heart. Ann. Int. M., 1931, 4: 1373-86. ---- Injury: Casuistics. Aizinbud, J. M., & Skvotsov, M. D. [Rare case of heart injury] Klin, med., Moskva, 1937, 15: 129-31.— Blaha. J. [Case of perforation of the heart by a catheter to induce abor- tion] Bratisl. lek. listy, 1935, 15: 170-0.—Cantelmo, O. Sui meccanismi di emostasi spontanea nelle ferite del cuore (caso clinico) Ann. ital. chir., 1927, 6: 900-7.—Cox, D. M. Wounds of the heart; report of 2 cases. Arch. Surg., 1928, 17: 484-92.— Elkin, D. C. Wounds of the heart; report of 13 cases. Bull, Fulton Co. M. Soc, 1936, 10: No. 24, 5. Also J. Thorac. Surg., 1936, 5: 590-603.—Erkelens, A. D., & Zaayer, J. H. [Case of wound of the heart] Ned. tschr. geneesk., 1940, 84: 766.— Feldmann, S. Eigenartiger Fall einer nicht diagnostizierten Spatverletzung des Herzens. Zbl. Chir., 1937, 64: 68-70.— Frankenberg, B. A. [Case of multiple injuries of the heart] Khirurgia, Moskva, 1939, No. 2-3, 154.—Gilchrist, A. R. Wounds of the heart; a study of 3 cases. Brit. M. J., 1929, 1: 723-6.—Hunter. W. C, Staub, R. R., & Lunsford, W. B. Penetration of the heart by an aluminum pipestem. Arch. Path., Chic, 1928, 6: 807-11.—Laskovsky, V. V. [Injuries of the heart; material from the Lenin Institute for Emergency Aid and Traumatology in Rostov on the Don] Vest, khir., 1936, 45: 18-24.—LeinofT, H. D. Non-penetrating injuries of the heart; report of 2 cases. Bull. N. York M. Coll., 1938, 1: 246-52.—Meixner, K. Ungewohnliches langes Ueberleben nach Herzverletzungen. Deut. Zschr. gerichtl. Med., 1929, 13: 250-5.—Nikolaev, G. F. [Two cases of rare injuries of the heart] Khirurgia, Moskva, 1939, No. 5, 109-11.—Odes, L. A. [Wounds of the heart according to material from the Nechaev Hospital for the past 16 years (1922-38)] Vest, khir., 1941, 61: 461-70.—Penkovsky, B. I). [Case report of heart injury] Khirurgia, Moskva, 1937, No. 9, 154.—Pergola, J., & Reinhold. Deux observations de plaies du coeur. Bull. Soc. nat. chir., Par., 1933, 59: 196-204.—Puga, M. J., & Acuna, M. Dos casos clinicos de herida del corazon. Bol. Soc cir. Chile, 1932, 10: 356-60.—Sabourin, J. Reflexions sur 2 cas de plaies du cceur. Gaz. med. France, 1937, 44:439.—Stonkus, S. [Case of isolated injury of the pericardium and heart] Medicina, Kaunas, 1939, 20: 835.—Tejerina Fotheringham, W. Evoluci6n clfnica y constataciones anat6micas en un herido de coraz6n. Rev. med. Rosario, 1934, 24: 667-76.—Vakhrameev, P. I. [Case of injury of the heart] Khirurgia, Moskva, 1937, 164.----- [Seven case reports of heart injuries] Vest, khir., 1937, 52: No. 8, 181-5. ---- Injury: Commotion. Bohmig, R. Pathologisch-anatomische Befunde bei 3 Todesfallen nach Commotio cordis. Zschr. Kreislaufforsch., 1941, 33: 73-84.—Brunner, W. Zur Commotio cordis. Zbl. Chir., 1939, 66: 2145-8— Formijne, P. [Commotio cordis] Ned. tschr. geneesk., 1940, 84: 763-6.—Glatzel, H. Spatfolgen nach Commotio cordis. Deut. med. Wschr., 1936, 62: 377-9. Also Zbl. inn. Med., 1936, 57: 547.—Jacobi. Zur Commotio cordis. Arch, orthop. UnfaUchir., 1936-37, 37: 418-21.— Kastert, J. Pathologisch-anatomische Veranderungen am Herzmuskel bei experimenteller Commotio cordis. Virchows Arch., 1939-40, 305: 494-504.—Kiilbs, F. Commotio cordis nach Boxen. Med. Klin., Berl., 1937, 33: 377.—Randerath, E. Friihveranderungen des Herzens nach Commotio cordis. Verh. Deut. path. Ges., 1937, 30: 163-70.—Riedinger. Commotio cordis. Schweiz. med. Wschr., 1941, 71: 1106.—Roverio, G. Un caso di commotio cordis visto dal lato infortunistico. Riv. med., 1936, 44: 83-5.—Schlomka. G. Die Bedeutung der Commotio cordis und ihre Folgen fiir den arztlichen Sach- verstandigen. Aerztl. Sachverst. Ztg, 1934, 40: 87-104.----- Commotio cordis und ihre Folgen (die Einwirkung stumpfer Brustwandtraumen auf das Herz) Erg. inn. Med. Kinderh., 1934, 47: 1-92. —•---- La conmoci6n cardiaca y sus con- secuencias. Rev. med. germ. iber. amer., 1935, 8: 409-17. ------ Commotio cordis und ihre Folgen. Zbl. inn. Med., 1936, 57: 225-43. ------ Experimentelle Untersuchungen iiber den Einfluss stumpfer Brustkorbtraumen auf das Herz; das besondere Verhalten sensibilisierter Tiere. Zschr. ges. exp. Med., 1933-34, 92: 552-72. ------ Der chronische post- kommotionelle Herzschaden. Ibid., 1934, 93: 751-74.— Spiihler, O. Zur Frage der Commotio cordis. Schweiz. med. Wschr., 1937, 67: 571-6. HEART 209 HEART --- Injury: Contusion. Gils, G. *Plotzlicher Spattod nach Herz- kontusion durch Bruststeckschuss [Heidelberg] 21p. 22;-zcm. Walldorf (Baden) 1936. Jordan, W. *Die bei stumpfer Gewaltein- wirkung auf den Brustkorb beobachteten Ver- letzungen des Herzbeutels und des Herzens [Munchen] 32p. 8? Wiirzb., 1936. Barber, H. Contusion of the myocardium. Brit. M. J., 1940 2- 520 -2.-----& Osborn, G. R. A fatal case of myo- cardial contusion. Brit. Heart J., 1941, 3: 127-31.—Beck, C. S. Contusions of the heart. J. Am. M. Ass., 1935, 104: 109-14 —Burstein, J., & Marshak, R. H. Contusion of the heart N. York State J. M., 1940, 40: 59-61.- Contusion of the heart. Med. J. Australia, 1940, 2: 671.—Elkin, D. C. Traumatic lesions of the thorax with 3 cases of cardiac con- tusion. South. M. J., 1935, 28: 4-11.—Hadorn, W., & Till- mann, A. Ueber Contusio cordis. Zschr. Kreislaufforsch., 1936 28: 185-90.—Kissane, R. W. Cardiac contusion. In Pract. Libr. M. & S., 1940 Suppl., 318-32. ------ & Koons, R A. Management and treatment of myocardial contusion. Tr. Am. Ther. Soc, 1938, 38: 61-4— Moritz, A. R., & Atkins, J. P. Cardiac contusion: an experimental and pathologic study. Arch. Path., Chic, 1938, 25: 445-62. Also repr — Muller. Lesions du coeur et des gros vaisseaux par trauma- tismes fermes directs. Echo med. nord, 1933, 37: 181-6.— Munck, W. [Examination of heart injuries caused by blunt objects] Hospitalstidende, 1937, 80: 525-37.—Peutz, J. L. A. [Injury of the heart caused by a blunt object without apparent external symptoms] Ned. tschr. geneesk., 1939, 83: 1049-55.—■ Schlomka, G. Die akute traumatische Herzdilatation. Verh. Deut. Ges. inn. Med., 1933, 45. Kongr., 220-9. ------ & Schmitz, M. Experimentelle Untersuchungen iiber den Ein- fluss stumpfer Brustkorbtraumen auf das Elektrokardiogramm. Zschr. ges. exp. Med., 1932, 83: 779-82. ------ Experi- mentelle Untersuchungen iiber den Einfluss stumpfer Brust- korbtraumen auf das Herz. Ibid., 1932-33, 85: 171-96. ----- Die akute traumatische Herzdilatation. Ibid., 1933, 90: 301-18.—Smith, L. B., & McKeown, H. J. Contusion of the heart; report of a case with serial electrocardiograms. Am. Heart J., 1939, 17: 561-8.—Spuhler, O. Ueber Herz- kontusionen. Helvet. med. acta, 1937, 4: 727.—Warburg, E. [Subacute and chronic lesions of the myocardium caused by injuries with blunt objects] Nord. med., 1939, 2: 1157-66 — Williams, G. A. Contusion of heart with aortic regurgitation; complete recovery. Am. J. Surg., 1936, 34: 110-2. --- Injury: Diagnosis. Bigger, I. A. The diagnosis of heart wounds. South. M. J., 1936, 29: 18-23.------The diagnosis and treatment of heart wounds; with a summary of 34 cases. Med. Ann. Dis- trict of Columbia, 1940, 9: 390-5. ------ The diagnosis and treatment of heart wounds; with a summary of 25 cases. South. M. J., 1940, 33: 6-11.—Doughty, R. G. The diagnosis and management of heart wounds. J. S. Carolina M. Ass., 1929, 25: 539-43.—Elkin, D. C. The diagnosis and treatment of wounds of the heart; a review of 22 cases; clinical lecture at San Francisco session. J. Am. M. Ass., 1938, 111: 1750-3 — Feldman, S. R. [Peculiar case of undiagnosed heart injury] Vest, khir., 1937, 49: 109.—Hoche, O. Zur Diagnostik der Herzverletzungen. Wien. klin. Wschr., 1929, 42: 644.— Mialaret, J. Plaie du coeur k symptomatologie> clinique reduite diagnostiquee radiologiquement; plaie de l'estomac; thoracolaparotomie; guerison. Mem. Acad, chir., Par., 1940, 66: 289-95.—Nather, K., & Urban, K. Zur Rontgendiagnostik der akuten Herzverletzungen. Mitt. Grenzgeb. Med. Chir., 1926-27, 40: 313-26.—Shtivel, E. [Diagnosis of injuries of the heart from the view point of internal medicine] Sovet. klin., 1933, 19: 124-6. --- Injury, electric and roentgen. Wolffersdorff, H. [J.] von. *Folgeer- scheinungen des Starkstromes am Herzen. 68p. 8? Lpz., 1932. Englmann. Klinik und Pathologie der Rontgenschadigung des Herzens. Verh. Deut. Rontg. Ges., 1934, 27: 40.—Groedel, F. M. Klappenfehler als Folge eines elektrischen Traumas. Mschr. Unfallh., 1933, 40: 593-600.—Koeppen, S. Der elektrische Unfall und das Herz. Hippokrates, Stuttg., 1941, 12: 449-55.—Rating, B., & Parade, G. W. Zur Frage der Herzschadigung durch Rontgenstrahlen. Fortsch. Roentgen- strahl., 1937, 56: Kongrh., 124-6.—W, D. Herzschadigungen durch elektrische Unfalle. Umschau, 1941, 45: 269. --- Injury: Electrocardiography. Destarac, A. M. Contribution a l'etude des modifications electrocardiographiques au cours des plaies du coeur. 68p. 8? Par., 1936. Bjerlov, H. [Injuries of the heart with changes in the electrocardiogram] Hygiea, Stockh., 1932, 94: 74-85.— Boyd, L. J., & Scherf, D. El electrocardiograma en las in- jurias epicardicas, endocardicas y miocardicas subyacentes, localizadas. Rev. argent, card., 1940-41, 7: 1-17. -Brody, J. G. The electrocardiogram as an aid to the surgeon in wounds of the heart. ^ Ohio M. J., 1934, 30: 574-6.—Figarella, J. Suites eioignees d'une plaie du coeur; eiectrocardiogramme! Marseille med., 1936, 73: 728.—Fischer, L. Herzverletzung und Elektrokardiogramm. Arch. klin. Chir., 1937, 188: 557-66.—Kienle, F. Elektrokardiographische Beobachtungen bei blutiger Herzverletzung. Zschr. Kreislaufforsch., 1938, 30: 496-500.—Kisch, B., Nahum, L. H., & Hoff, H. E. The pre- dominance of surface over deep cardiac injury in producing changes m the electrocardiogram. Am. Heart J., 1940, 20: 174-85.—Mukhadze, G. M. [Cardiography in recent wounds of the heart| Vest, khir., 1929, 16: 86-102.—Oppolzer, R. Zwei Fiille von Herzverletzungen und elektrokardiographische Befutide. Wien. klin. Wschr., 1936, 49: 892.—Routier, D., & Joly, F. Eiectrocardiogramme dans un cas de plaie du cceur Arch. mal. coeur, 1934, 27: 551-4.- Solovay, J., Rice, G. D., & Solovay, H. U. Electrocardiographic changes in stab and gunshot wounds of the heart, with review of the literature. Ann. Int. M., 1941-42, 15: 465-77.—Symon, L. [Electro- cardiogram in injury of the heart] Cas. lek. cesk., 1940, 79: 22-5.;—Vaghi, A. Etude electrocardiographique dans un cas d'accident du travail avec blessure du coeur. Arch. mal. coeur, 1934, 27: 351-4.—Villarreal, F. V. El electrocardio- grama en las heridas del corazon. Rev. cir. Hosp. Juarez, Mex., 1936, -7: 157-68.—Wood, P. Electrocardiographic changes of a T2 pattern in pericardial lesions and in stab wounds of the heart. Lancet, Lond., 1937, 2: 796-9. ---- Injury: Forensic aspect. Bardou, V. Eclatement partiel de la pointe du coeur. Ann. med. leg., 1936, 16: 641.—Modi, J. P. Heart injuries. In his Textb. Med. Jurispr., 6. ed., Bombay, 1940, 283-7.— Munck, W. Untersuchungen iiber Herzverletzungen durch stumpfe Gewalt. Deut. Zschr. gerichtl. Med., 1937, 29: 56-74.—Ponticaccia, L. Cardiopatia da trauma (perizia medico-legale) Gior. clin. med., 1933, 14: 1393-1414.— Rothfuchs. Die Schuss- und Stichverletzungen des Herzens. Deut. Zschr. gerichtl. Med., 1926, 8: 151-61.—Schnizer, von. Dienstbeschadigung fiir eine Herzinsufhzienz abgelehnt (Obergutachten) Med. Klin., Berl., 1927, 23: 1546.—Siebert, P. Ein kasuistischer Beitrag zur Frage der traumatischen Endokarditis. Deut. med. Wschr., 1933, 59: 1643.—Stormer, A. Unfall und Herz. In Handb. ges. Unfallh. (F. Konig & G. Magnus) Stuttg., 1934, 4: 396-436.—Zannoni, A. Identi- ficabilita deH'arma in casi di ferite del cuore da strumenti da punta e taglio. Gazz. internaz. med. chir., 1931, 39: 531-5. ---- Injury, gunshot. See also Heart, Foreign body: Projectile; Heart muscle, Foreign body. B alters, W. * Ueber Herzschussverletzungcn. 28p. 8? Marb., 1926. Rothburd, C. M. *De l'electrocardiogramme dans les plaies du coeur en clinique, avec une observation personnelle par coup de feu. 24p. 8? Lausanne, 1936. Aixala R. Herida del coraz6n por arma de fuego. Rev. med. cubana, 1934, 45: 489-96.—Allen, C. W. Removal of bullet from walls of heart and report of stab wound of heart. N. Orleans M. & S. J., 1927-28, 80: 458-64.—Bean, W. B. Bullet wound of the heart, with coronary artery ligation. Am. Heart J., 1941, 21: 375-81.—Bromeis, H. Sekundare Herz- verletzung durch Geschossplitter. Zbl Chir., 1941, 68: 491-3.—Dalger. Sur un cas de blessure perforante du cceur par balle de revolver. Arch. med. pharm. nav., 1929, 119: 540-3 —Farinas, P. L. Herida del corazon por arma de fuego. Rev. med. cubana, 1934, 45: 497-501.—Fraser, W. A., & Texon, M. Electrocardiographic findings associated with a gunshot wound of the heart; report of a case. N. England J M., 1941, 225: 286-90.—Gemchujny, A. A. [Gun-shot wound of the heart] Nov. khir., Moskva, 1926, 2: 179 — Hesse, E. Ein Fall von 26jahrigem Dauerresultat einer Herznaht nach Schussverletzung. Zbl. Chir., 1935, 62: 1874-7.—Ivankovich, K. [Case history of gun-shot wound of the heart] Vest, khir., 1927, 10: No. 30, 192.—Klose, H. Ueber Herznahte mit Vorstellung eines operativ geheilten Herzspitzenschusses. Munch, med. Wschr., 1926, 73: 1382. ------ Blutsperre bei einem Herzspitzenschuss. Zbl. Chir., 1926, 53: 1746-8.—Laqueur, B. Eine Kombinationsklassi- fikation der Schussverletzungen des Herzens. Arch, orthop. UnfaUchir., 1930-31, 29: 198-202.—Luthi, A. Ueber Herz- schusse. Schweiz. med. Wschr., 1926, 56: 454—Mangili, C. A proposito di ferite lacere per colpo d'arma da fuoco. Gazz. internaz. med. chir., 1932, 40: 552.—Matti, H. Ueber einen Fall von Herzschuss mit Ligaturinfarkt. Schweiz. med. Wschr., 1938, 68: 611-3.—Meier, L. A. [Case of a sutured gunshot wound of heart and left lung] Vest, khir., 1930, 22: 124-7—Nafe, B. Funktion des Herzens nach alter Schuss- verletzung. Deut. Zschr. Chir., 1936, 247: 558—Nikolsky, N N [Two cases of gun-shot injuries of the heart] Khirurgia, Moskva, 1938, No. 6, 148-51.—Oppolzer, R. Heilung ernes Herzdurchschusses mit Durchtrennung des hinteren absteigen- den Astes der rechten Coronararterie nebst elektrokardio- graphischer Verfolgung. Deut. Zschr. Chir., 1933-34, 242: Q20-7—Schifferli, E. Ein Fall von Fortbewegung nach 227475—vol. 7, 4th series----14 HEART 210 HEART schwerer Sebussverletzung des Ihrzenf Deui. Zschr. gerichtl. Med., 1939. 31: 40-3. Schmidt-Weyland. P. Totaler Herz- blork nach Sebussverletzung von 36 Jahren. Deut. med. Wschr., 1931, 57: 2014-6.—Sprenger, O. Elektrokardiogramm bei Schussverletzungen des Herzens. Verh. Deut. Ges. Kreis- laufforsch., 1939, 12: 151-6- Stepanov. A. S. [Gunshot wounds of the heart] Vest, khir., 1939, 57: 364.—Stern, R. Zur Frage der Herzmuskelschadigung dun-h Tangential- schiisse, erlautert an einem Obergutachten. .Msclir. Unfallh., 1932, 39: 111-4.—Syller, R. Zur Behandlung veralteter Herzstecksclni". . Klin. Wschr., 1927, 6: 744-8.—Turner, i;. (J. Gunshot wounds of the heart. Brit. M. J., 1941, 1: 93K 4 1 Lrrutia, J. F. Herida del corazon por arma de fuego. Hev. med. cubana, 1934, 45: 487.—Zambrzycki, J. I Vlam.—Stokea syndrome after a gun-shot wound of the heart] Polska gaz., lek., 1933, 12: 871-3. ----Injury: Military aspect. Pitre, C. *Contribution a l'etude dc la localisation radiologique et de 1'extraction des projectiles de guerre; les projectiles du coeur [Lyon] 14Sp. 8? Bourg, 1918. Steffens, W. Herzsteckschusse; Beobach- tungen durch fast zwei Jahrzehnte an 109 Sehuss- verletzten des Weltkrieges. 332p. S? Lpz., V.r.Ht. Filderman, L. Protection du coeur contre les projectiles. Bull. Soc. med. Paris, 1939-40. 9-11,—Giercke, H. W. Die Krie^sverletzungen des Herzens. Veroff. Kriegs Konstpath., 1920, 2: H. 5, 1-83.—Laurent, O. L'extraction des projectiles eardici-pericardiques. Bull. Acad, med., Par., 1915, 3. ser., 74: 657-60.- Siegmund, H. Spatfolgen einer Kriegsschussverlet- zuug des Herzen* (mit Bemerkungen iiber die traumatische Kudokarditis) Frankf. Zschr. Path., 1935, 48: 493-8.— Steffens. Beobachtungen an 110 Herzsteckschiissen, darunter au 38 eigenen Fallen. Fortsch. Roentgenstrahl., 1936, 54: Kongrh., 76-9. ---- Injury, penetrating. See also other subheadings. Balthazard, V. Un cas de survie prolongee a la suite de plaie penetrante du coeur. Ann. med. leg., 1928, 8: 117-9.— ( am pea no, L. Plaie penetrante du coeur operee; resultats apres 13 mois. Rev. chir , Bucur., 1937, 40: 195-7.—Cossio, P., Tejerina Fotheringham, W. |et al.] Herida penetrant* del coraz6n y alteraciones electrocardiogr^ficas consecutivas. Sem. med., B. Air., 1933, 40: pt 2, 612-7.—Mentl, S. [Per- forating wound of the heart healed by suture with develop- ment of left brachial block and aneurysm in the cicatrix] Cas. 16k. cesk., 1937, 76: 1513-9.—Morris, K. A. Penetrating wounds of the heart; report of 2 cases. Am. J. Surg. 1938 41: 108-11.—Mustard. R. L., Solovay, J., & Ford, H. Pene- trating wound of the heart with electrocardiographic tracings. Ibid., 1941, 53: 492-5.—Oudard. Deux cas de blessures trans- fixiantes du coeur. Bull. Soc. nat. chir., Par., 1926, 52: 872- 5-—Vargas Molinare, R. Herida transfixiante del corazdn Bol. Sue. cir. Chile, 1932, 10: 250—1 — Ward, T. P., & Parker, W. (;. Penetrating wounds of the heart. Am. J. Sure 194o' 50:712-4. S" ' ---- Injury: Sequelae. See also Angina pectoris; Endocarditis; Heart- block; Heart dilatation, &c. Saltner, L. *Ueber Spatfolgen der zunachst nicht todlichen Stich- und Schussverletzungen des Herzens (mit einem kasuistischen Beitrae) 32p. 8? Miinch., 1931. ^yARBURG, E. J. Subacute and chronic pericardial and myocardial lesions due to non- penetrating traumatic injuries. 147p. 271/cm Kbh., 1938. 7 9aso^„G- T traumi nell'etiogenesi delle cardiopatie. Rinasc med 1936, 13; 670,-Cseh, E. Histologische Untersuchu^en des Herzens eines an Commotio cordis Verstorbenen. Deut Zschr. gerichtl. Med., 1934-35, 24: 322-9.—Duhot, E Les' cardiopathies traumatizes en clinique. Prat, med fr 1933 14: .2,-o0—Dzhanelidze, J. J. [Diseases of the coronary arteries in heart injuries] \est. khir., 1926, 5: pt 14, 14-33.— Gronwald, G 1 eber *patfolgen nach Herzmuskel- und Coro- nargefassverletzungen. Arch. klin. Chir., 1933 174-249-80 — Hyman, A. S & Fisher J. L. Posttraumatic'disturbances' of the heart. Am. Heart J., 1926-27, 2: 61-71.—KuIbsF & Strauss, L. H. Herz und Trauma; weitere experimented I ntersuchungen. Khn. Wschr., 1932, 11- 1572-5—Mpnti S., & Pour. S. Evolution d'un bloc de branche et d'un ane- vnsme du coeur k la suite d'une blessure penetrante CardL ogia Basel, 1938 2: 376-80.-Muller & Demarez, R s£ le mecanisme de la mort dans les plaies du coeur; a proDos d,'ne,_ observation personnels. Ann. med. lig 1939 1? 367-7. -Revers, F. E. [Heart defects due to trauma] Ned tschr. geneesk., 1937, 81: 306 12. Seiro, V. | Mortality due to heart, wounds] II\ gica, Stockh., I'.l32, 94: 107. Singleton, A. O. Wounds of the heart and a discussion of the causes uf death. Tr. South. Surg. Ass., 1933, 45: 305-31. Also Am. J. Surg., 1933, 20: 515-41. Also repr.—Stafford. E. S. Uenal failure as a complication of cardiac tamponade; with report of a case. J. Thorac. Surg., 1939-40, 9: 652 5.-Szepe, L. Entwicklung von elastischen Fasern in experimentellen Herz- wunden. Verh. Anat. Ges., 1939, 47: 247-54. ---- Injury: Stab wound. See also Heart ventricle, Injury. Fedeklin, A. *IJeber Stiehverletzungen des Herzens. 26p. 8? Frankf. a. M., 192o. Hecker, J. *Ueber Herzstichverlel zungeii. 371>. S? Greifsw., 1929. Martin, H. *I)ie gerichtsiirztliche Bedeutung todlicher Herzstichverletzungen [Minister] 31 p. 21,Jcm. Frankf., 1935. Streule, (). *Die Stich- und Schussverlcl- zungen des Herzens [Miinchen] 29p. 8? Kallmiinz, 1932. Abramson, P. D. Stab wound of the heart. N. Orleans M. & S. J., 1933, 86: 376-80.— Bean, W. B. Accidental injury to the heart by needle puncture; a report of 4 cases. N. England J. M., 1938, 219: 257-9.—Beck, C. S. Injuries to the heart, stab wounds, and contusions. Proc. Interst. Post- grad. M. Ass. N. America, 1938, 125-7.—Beekman, F. Stab wound of the heart; a report of 2 cases. Arch. Surg., 1933, 26: 510-15. Also repr.—Benet, G., & Spivey, C. G. Suture of stab wound of the heart; report of case. J. Am. M. Ass., 1935, 104: 1979-81. Also repr.—Biancalani, A. Contributo alia conoscenza delle ferite del cuore da aghi. Gazz. internaz. med. chir., 1930, 38: 388-400.—Blalock, A. Stab wound of heart. Ann. Surg., 1931, 93: 1278.—Bowie, H. C. Stab wounds of the heart. Bull. School M. Univ. Maryland, 1939-40, 24: 230-5.—Canuto, G. Le ferite da ago al cuore. Minerva med., Tor., 1928, 8: pt 2, 830-43.—Clark, J. F. Suture of stab wound of the heart; report of a case. Texas J. M., 1933, 29: 203-5.—Clavel, C, & Mathieu, J. Plaie penetrante du coeur par coup de couteau, ventricules; suture du coeur; guerison. Lyon chir., 1938, 35: 721-4.—Culpepper, A. L. Stab wounds of the heart; a case report with a note on some special problems N. Orleans M. & S. J., 1938-39, 91: 283-8.—Daniel (Dr) Williams takes priority in successful operation for stab wound of human heart. J. Nat. M. Ass., Newark, 1936, 28: 164 — Davenport, G. L., Blumenthal, B., & Cantril, S. Electro- cardiographic studies of a stab wound of the heart. J. Thorac. Surg., 1935-36, 5: 208-12. Davenport, G. L., & Markle, P. The electrocardiogram in stab wounds of the heart; a case report. Ibid., 1934, 3: 374-9. —Derzhavets, M. A. [Knife wound of the heart] Vest, khir., 1938, 55: 323. -Elkin, D. C, GVG- & A,bram8«n. A. Stab wound of M MontlT l«m^dlG%C.ta^P70na^' report °f a case- Virginia ivi. ivionth., 1938, 65: 35-7.— Petersen, M. C. Safety pin HEART 211 HEART through the heart 18 months. J. Am. M. Ass., 1929, 92: 1599.—Ramsdell, E. G. Stab wounds of the heart. Ann. Surg., 1934, 99: 141-51.—Remetei, F. F. [Puncture of the heart] Orv. hetil., 1933, 77: 880. ----— Ueber die Stich- verletzungen des Herzens nebst zwei Fallen. Zbl. Chir., 1934, 61: 1723-6.—Schlomka, G. Elektrokardiographische Beob- achtungen bei Herzstichverletzung; Beitrag zur Genese der Angina pectoris. Deut. med. Wschr., 1931, 57: 630-3.— Schmidt, L. [Heart injuries caused by needles] Orv. hetil., 1937, 81: 32-5.—Seemen, H. von. Herzstich und Gasbrand- thorax. Deut. Zschr. Chir., 1929, 215: 321-6.—Sommer. Herzstichverletzung. Med. Klin., Berl., 1926, 22: 1243 — Sprang, D., & Watson, W. G. A case of successful suture of a stab wound of the heart. Bull. Johns Hopkins Hosp., 1940, 67: 66.—Stenbuck, J. B. Successful suture of a penetrating stab wound of the heart. N. York State J. AL, 1936, 36: 1867-70. ---■— Two cases of successful suture of penetrating stab wounds of the heart; with some observations on the sub- ject. J. Mount Sinai Hosp. N. York, 1940-41, 7: 520-9.— Stonkus, S. [Case of an operation for knife-wound in the heart] Medicina, Kaunas, 1940, 21: 200-3.— Strieder, J. W. Stab wound of the heart; report of a case treated conservatively. J. Thorac. Surg., 1938-39, 8: 576.—Talyshinsky, K. B. [Case report of a heart injury due to a needle] Vest, khir., 1937, 52: No. 8, 221.—Timofeev, V. S. [Knife wounds of the heart] Ibid., 1939, 57: 363.—Wagner, H. Beitrage zur Chirurgie des Herzens und des Herzbeutels; iiber eine eigenartige Herz- stichverletzung im Sulcus interventricularis mit Eroffnung beider Ventrikel und Durchtrennung des absteigenden Astes der linken Kranzarterie; Tod eine Stunde nach der Herznaht. Arch. klin. Chir., 1926, 143: 58-77.—Warthen, H. J. Stab wound of the heart; report of a case. Ann. Surg., 1935, 102: 147-52. ---- Injury: Treatment. See also Heart, Surgery: Suture; Heart hormone, Therapeutic use. Guntz, G. E. *Beitrage zur operativen Be- handlung frischer Herzverletzungen [Miinchen] 32p. 8? [Grossenhain i. Sa.] 1927. Rastaghi, D. Des plaies du coeur sans hemopericarde; traitement des plaies de la region precordials 91p. 8? Lyon, 1937. Bergenfelst, E. [Case of operation in heart injury] Hygiea, Stockh., 1932, 94: 65-73.—Bigger. I. A. Heart wounds: a report of 17 patients operated upon in the Medical College of Virginia hospitals and a discussion of the treatment and prog- nosis. J. Thorac. Surg., 1938-39, 8: 239-53. ------& Porter, W. B. Wounds of the heart. Internat. Clin., 1934, 44. ser., 1: 132-58, 8 pl.—Brocq, P. Deux cas de plaies du coeur operees: 1 guerison; 1 mort. Bull. Soc. nat. chir., Par., 1926, 52: 718-23.—Cahen, P. Traitement des plaies du coeur et du pericarde. J. med. Paris, 1935, 55: 7-10.—Dzhanelidze, J. J., & Kamenchik, M. G. [One thousand cases of operative treatment of wounds of the heart] Nov. khir. arkh., 1941, 49: 101-20.— Elkin, D. C. The diagnosis and treatment of cardiac trauma. Ann. Surg. 1941, 114: 169-85. Also Tr. South. Surg. Ass., 1936, 49: 99-102.—Gignoux & Chauve. Observation d'une plaie du coeur oper6e. Loire med., 1931, 45: 277-9.—Kiszty, E. Ein operierter Fall von Herzverletzung. Zbl. Chir., 1931, 58: 76-80.—Luccarelli, V. Un intervento per ferita del cuore. Policlinico, 1927, 34: sez. prat., 199-202.—Maas, J. Tecnica para tratar la heridas del corazon. Rev. cir. Hosp. Juarez, Mix., 1936, 7: 307.—Mamikonov, M. I. [Various views en surgical treatment in wounds of the heart] Vest, khir., 1928, 14: 116-22.—Mayer, J. M. The clinical management of injuries to the heart and pericardium; report of 7 cases. Surg. Gyn. Obst., 1936, 62: 852-64.—Moritsch, P. Beitrag zur Kasuistik operierter Herzverletzungen. Wien. med. Wschr., 1930, 80: 1289-92.—Nana, A. Penetrierende operierte Herz- wunde; Spatresultat. Zbl. Chir., 1939, 66: 2198-201 — Northrop, H. L. Wounds of the heart. Hahneman. Month., 1935, 70: 645-51.—Otero y Gama, M. Lesiones del corazon. An. clin. Hosp. Juarez, Mex., 1931, 1: 84-8.—Piria, P., & Martiarena, L. H. Heridas del coraz6n y del pericardio. Bol. Inst. clin. quir., B. Air., 1940, 16: 133-76.—Simionescu, I., Racovita Jalova, C, & Paraschiv, S. [Two cases of urgent surgery for wounds in the precordial region; suture of the heart; convales- cence] Spitalul, 1940, 60: 61.—Sommer, R. Zur Versorgung frischer Herzwunden. Zbl. Chir., 1939, 66: 2292-8.—Sosnia- kov, N. G. [Case of retarded operation in isolated injury of the heart] Vest, khir., 1938, 55: 615.—Stor. Zur Behandlung von Herzverletzungen. Zbl. Chir., 1938, 65: 2342-7.—Watson, C. M., & Watson J. R,. Autotransfusion in the treatment of wounds of the heart. J. Am. M. Ass., 1936, 106: 520-3.— Zhilin, A. G. [Two case reports of operative treatment of injury of the heart and pericardium] Vest, khir., 1937, 52: No. 8, 220. ---- Innervation. See Heartbeat, Regulation; Heart nerves. ---- Insufficiency. See Heart failure. ---- isolated. See also Heart, Transplantation; Heart-lung preparation; also under such headings as Heart, Pharmacology; Heart muscle, Metabolism, &c. For explantation of heart tissue see Endocar- dium; Heart muscle, Explantation. Daly, I. de B., & Thorpe, W. V. An isolated mammalian heart preparation capable of performing work for prolonged periods. J. Physiol., Lond., 1932-33, 77: Proc. 10; 1933 79- 199.—Gramenitsky, M. I. Uebeiiebendes Gefass-Herz- Iroschpraparat. Arch. exp. Path., Lpz., 1929, 143: 29. ------ [Circular preparation of a completely isolated frog's heart] Ir. Vtor. Leningr. med. inst., 1935, No. 0, 74-9.—Katz. L.. N., & Mendlowitz, M. The isolated heart circuit. J Physiol., Lond., 1938, 92: Proc, 2.—Kotsovsky, D. Cceur isole de grenouille a l'age different. Riv. biol., 1930, 12: 207-10.—Krontowski, A. A. Pathologisch-phvsiologische Beobachtungen iiber Hei zexplantate. Arch. exp. Zellforsch., 192o, 1: 58-65.—Lindbergh, C. A. An aoparatus for the cul- ture of whole organs. J. Exp. M., 1935, 62: 409-31, pl.— Morosow, B. D. Explantationsversuche an getrockneten und wiederbelebten Herzen der Menschen- und Huhnerembryonen. Miinch. med. Wschr., 1928, 75: 1713. Also Arch. exp. Zell- forsch., 1929, 8: 154-60.—Negrobov, A. I. [Methods of a single experiment on 2 isolated hearts of'warm-blooded animals] J. Physiol. USSR, 1938, 25: 348-52.—Orzechowski, G. Ver- suche an dem nach Langendorff isolierten Katzenherzen. Arch. exp. Path., Berl., 1933, 172: 471-85.—Rigler, R. Das Vorhofkammerkreislaufpraparat. Ibid., 1931, 163: 295-310.— Straub, W. Vorrichtung zur Verhiitung des Leertropfens des ausgeschnittenen Froschherzens nach Straub. Ibid., 1937, 185: 460.—Uhlmann, F., & Nobile, F. Verbesserte Versuchs- anordnung fiir Arbeiten mit dem isolierten Saugetierherzen. Ibid., 1939, 192: 189-201.—Velasco Lombardini, R., & Duo- marco, J. Tecnica de exteriorizacion y suspension del corazon en el perro; el bajo voltaje en el derrame pericardico; el prob- lema de las preponderancias. Rev. argent, card., 1934-35, 1: 138-44. ---- isolated: Function. See also Heart function; also subheadings of Heart muscle. Binet, L., & Perl 6s, L. Etude du cceur de l'escargot isole de l'organisme. Presse med., 1929, 37: 1441.—Boriani, A. Due interessanti grafiche di cuore isolato di rana. Boll. Soc. ital. biol. sper., 1936, 11: 402-4.—Drastich, L. Influence de l'excitation prealable du bulbe rachidien sur l'activite du coeur isol6 du lapin. C. rend. Soc. biol., 1931, 108: 987.— Hukuda, T., & Tanaka, K. Eine Methodik fiir die Funk- tionspriifung des isolierten Froschherzens. Jap. J. M. Sc, 1938, 11: Proc. Pharm., 51-3.—Katz, L. N. Observations on the external work of the isolated turtle heart. Am. J. Physiol., 1932, 99: 579-97.—Nikitin, A. I. [Anaphylactic manifestations in isolated hearts of rabbits and guinea-pigs] J. Physiol. USSR, 1940, 28: 394-8.— Parin, V. V., Glinkin, M. I., & Ukolova, M. A. [Mechanism of changes occuring in the cavities of an isolated heart of a mammal] Vest, rentg., 1936, 16: 277-84.—Spealman, C. R. The initial stabilization period of the perfused frog heart. Am. J. Physiol., 1941, 133: 458.— Tamura, M. Studies on the influence of the foregoing sub- minimal stimulus to the isolated perfused heart preparation. Seiikwai, 1929, 48: H. 7, 4. ---- isolated: Nutrition, perfusion, and resus- citation. See also Heart muscle, Metabolism. Finn, B. *Ueber die Wirkung von Nahr- fliissigkeiten auf das Herz [Bern] 14p. 8? Miinch., 1887. Acolat, L. Nouvelle disposition experimentale k reservoirs conjugues pour la circulation artificielle dans le cceur in situ des poecilothermes; son application a l'etude de la circulation des sangs arteriel et veineux dans I'appareil circulatoire central de la couleuvre. Ann. physiol., Par., 1934, 10: 850-5.— Beland, I. L., Moe, G. K., & Visscher, M. B. Use of aluminum metal in contact with blood in perfusion systems. Proc. Soc. Exp. Biol., N. Y., 1938-39, 39: 145-7.—Bogue, J. Y., & Greg- ory, R. A. A simplified heart oxygenator circuit for bloodfed hearts. Q. J. Exp. Physiol., Lond., 1939-40, 29: 105-9 — Clark, A. J., Gaddie, R., & Stewart, C. P. The anaerobic activity of the isolated frog's heart. J. Physiol, Lond., 1932, 75: 321-31.—Cole, W. H. A perfusing solution for the lobster, Homarus, heart and the effects of its constituent ions on the heart. J. Gen. Physiol., 1941-42, 25: 1-6. Also repr.— Cousy, R. La perfusion du coeur de grenouille a la solution glucose-bicarbonate. Arch, internat. physiol., Liege, 1923, 21: 90-107.—Dawson, W. T., & Bodansky, O. Interruption of perfusion of isolated rabbit heart upon reaction of coronary flow. Proc. Soc. Exp. Biol., N. Y., 1930-31, 28: 635.—Dubou- loz, P., & Offant, C. Au sujet de Taction de liquides de Ringer irradils sur le coeur de grenouille en circulation artificielle. C. rend. Soc. biol., 1933, 112: 373.— Duliere, W. Le lithium dans le liquide de perfusion du cceur de grenouille. Ibid., 1927, 96: 193-6.—Dumitresco-Mante, D., & Ciorapciu, S. HEART 212 HEART Lnction du glycocholatc et du taurocholate de soude en solu- tion dans le liquide de Ringer-Locke sur le coeur isol6 de la grenouille; absence d'une action bradycardisante. Ibid., 1929. 101: 225; 311.—Evans. C. L., Grande, F.. it Fong Ven Hsu. Two simple heart-oxvgenator circuits for bloodfed hearts. Q. J. Exp. Physiol., Lond., 1934, 24: 283-7.—Fredericq, L. I'n liquide de perfusion pour le coeur des poissons osseux inarins. Audi, internat. physiol., Liege, 1922-23, 20: 111- Gavrilescu, N.. & Ionescu, N. Procede pratique pour obtenir des perfusats actifs adrenaliniques et ac6tvlcholiniques. C. rend. Soc. biol., 1936, 123: 840.—Geigher, A. J., & Hambourger, W. E. Effect of excess sugars on the perfused rabbit heart. Ain. Heart J., 1938, 16: 261-77.—Gradinesco, A. Modifica- lions quantitatives de l'azote total contenu dans le coeur de gieimuille aprts circulation artificielle. C. rend. Soc. biol., P.I26, 95: 1043.- (iregorv, R. A. A new oxygenator for blood- perlused hearts. .1. Physiol., Lond., 1939, 95: Suppl., 49-51.— Merrick, J. F. the effects of irradiated defibrinated blood on the perfused heart. Am. J. Plnsiol.. 1929, 88: 706-8. ------ The toxic effects of defibrinated blood when perfused through i be isolated mammalian heart. Proc. Mayo Clin., 1929, 4: 146.—Hukuda, K.. & Suzuki, T. On a natural method of perfusion of a toad's heart. Nagoya J. M. Sc, 1934, 7: 173- 90.—Izquierdo. J. J. Influencia ejercida por los lfquidos normales de perfusi6n sobre el ritmo fundamental del corazon de la rana. (Jac med. Mexico, 1931, 62: 45-58.—Katz. G., Paine, \V. (;., & Tiller, P. M. A new method for coronary perfusion of the mammalian heart. Arch, internat. pharm. dyn.. Par., 1939, 61: 109-12.—Kodama, S. On the conduc- livity of perfusion fluid of frog's heart under abnormal atmos- pheric pressure; according to the experiment of H. Miyazaki and M. Ogata. Tohoku J. Exp. M., 1938, 34: 403-12.— bevy, R. Technique de perfusion du cceur de l'ecrevisse. i'. rend. Soc. biol., 1933, 113: 662-5.—Locke, F. S. L'action iles liquides physiologiques artificiels sur le coeur isol6 des mammiferes. Arch, internat. physiol., Liege, 1921, 18: 628- 12.—Matuoka, S. On the potassium contracture of the heart and the relation among concentrations of KG, CaCb and NaCl in the perfusing fluid. Nagoya J. M. Sc, 1935, 9: 127-49.— Morosow, B. D. Leber die Wiederbelebung des isolierten und getiockiieteii I'rosrhherzeiis. Klin. Wschr., 1927, 6: 2048.-- Ort, J. M.. & Markowitz. J. Hydrion concentration and edema in pei fused hearts of rabbits. Am. J. Physiol., 1930. 91: 60- I. Orzechowski, (i. Zur Wirkung kalium- und raleiunihaltiger Losungen auf das isolierte Froschherz. Arch. exp. Path , Berl., 1936, 181: 130.—Ossinovsky, N. I. Versuche einer \\ iederbelebung des isolierten Kinderherzens. Acta paediat., Upps., 1939, 27: 233-44. ■---— Titova, A. I. [et al.] | Attempts in animation of the isolated child's heart] Sovet. pediat., 1936, No. 9, 3-9.—Pal, R. K., & Prasad, S. A com- parative study of the effects of adding different sugars to the perfusion fluid through frogV heart and the influence of insulin over it. J. I'hysiol., bond.. 1934-35, 83: 285-91.—Popov. N. A., & Kudriavtsev. A. A. [Problem of keeping the heart of a frog alive in solutions of various ionic compounds] Tr. Inst. eksp. vet. med.. Moskva, 1929, 6: 40-7. Also Arch. exp. Path., Lpz., 1929-30, 147: 331-8.—Rahman, S. A., & Abhyankar, R. N. A suitable formula of Ringer's solution for perfusion work on the hearts of Indian frogs. Ind. J. M. Res., 1932, 20: 369-76.—Sobolev, M. F. [Viscidity and reaction of the medium in working on an isolated heart of a frog] J. eksp. biol, 1930, 13: 45-52.—Soejima, T. Ueber das Ueberleben des Rinderherzens. Fukuoka ikwadaigaku zasshi, 1928, 21: 91.—Sozi, T. Study of the perfusion fluid on the heart for poikilothermal animal. Jap. J. M. Sc, 1938, 5: Proc. Bio- physics, 128.—Takahashi, H. Ueber den Einfluss der Kon- zentrationssteigerung der Durchstromungsfliissigkeit auf das isolierte Froschherz. Tohoku J. Exp. M., 1933, 21: 592-600. ------ Ueber den Einfluss der Konzentrationssteigerung der Durchstromungsfliissigkeit durch Zusatz von Nichtelek- trolyten auf das isolierte Froschherz. Ibid., 601-12.—Takano, M. Studies on perfusion of isolated heart of toad. Jap J M. Sc, 1931, 2: No. 2, Tr. Biophysics, 17-20—Uraguchi,'k! On the method of perfusion of an isolated heart of toad. Ibid 1939-40, 12: Proc. Pharm., 180.—Venkatachalam, K., Vareed! C, & Ratnagiriswaran, A. N. An improved type of apparatus for perfusion of mammalian heart and a constant temperature bath for isolated organs. Ind. J. M. Res., 1934, 22: 11-5.__ Watchorn, E., & Murray, P. D. F. Loss of potassium from embryonic chick hearts in potassium-free media with and without calcium. Proc. R. Soc, Lond., 1938, ser. B, 124: 446-50.—Wiemer, P. Methodisches zur Langendorffschen Apparatur fur die Durchstromung des Warmbluterherzens Arch exp. Path., Lpz., 1929, 143: 1-9.—Yamamoto, H. On the change of pa of perfusion fluid of toad's heart. Jap. J. M Sc, 1939-40, 6: Proc. Biophysics, 126-8.—Ziganow, S. W Das Meerwasser als Durchstrbmungsflussiirkeit fiir das isolierte Froschherz. Biochem. Zschr., 1926, 170: 311-20. ---- isolated: Pharmacology. Barlow,.O. W. The influence of bicarbonate and phosphate buffers and of ( Oi on the functional activity of the perfused frog heart. Am. J. Physiol., 1929, 91: 47-57.— Cartolari C Ricerche sul cuore isolato; anione perclorico e K-ione Boll ^oc- jj,?1;. ^io!; 8Per- 193°. 5J 610-3.—Chin, K. Beeinflussung der Tatigkeit des ausgeschnittenen Herzens von Cytherea meretnx durch eine Reihe von Arzneimitteln. Jan I M ,Se 193S 11: Proc Pharm., 42-4— Combes. T. J. C Action du cyanure de sodium et de l'hynosulfite de sodium sur le cceur isol6 du crapaud. C. rend. Soc biol., 1927, 97: 12 10. Djourno, A., it Piffault, C. A propos de l'influence des ultra-violet.-, sur Taction pharmacodynamique de certaines matures colorantes perfusees dans le cceur des bactraciens. J. physiol. path, gen., 1936, 34: 746-56— Gorski, P. F. Ueber die Reaktionsvcr- anderung des isolierten Herzens nach Adrenalineinfuhrung ins Tierblut. Zschr. ges. exp. Med., 1929, 67: 388-92—Goure- vitch, A. Action de l'aldehyde acetique sur le coeur survivant du lapin; arret de la perfusion du cceur. C. rend. Soc. biol., 1928, 98: 27.—Guerra. Contribution a 1 etude du travail du coeur de la grenouille; le minimum indispensable de NaCl; action du K dans les solutions de perfusion glucosees. Arch. internat. physiol., Li6ge, 1924, 23: 299 312.—Blyin. Z. A. [Typical action of aqueous solutions of dry endocrine gland preparations ou the isolated heart of frog] J. eksp. biol., 1929, 11: 10-4.- Kimmelwliel, P. Untersuchungen iiber die Lipoid- wirkung am liberlebenden Froschherz. Virchows Arch., 1932, 284: 835-52.—Ko, H. Ueber den Einfluss von Vitamin-Bi auf die Arzneiwirkungen am isolierten Froschherzen. Jap. J. M. Sc, 1939-40, 12: Proc Pharm., 167-70.—Koda. N. About the influence of gas adsorption on the gas effect during its phar- macological action on the extirpated frog-heart. Acta Schola; med. Univ. Kioto, 1927-28, 10: 137-73.—Larscn. V. Die Wirkung einiger phenylsubstituierter aliphatischer Amine auf das iiberlebende durchstromte Froschherz. Skand. Arch. Physiol., Berl., 1939, 82: 288-98.—Lefeuvre, C. & Gregoire, F. Action de quelques eaux distiliees aromatiques sur le coeur isoie. J. physiol. path, gen., 1930, 28: 833-40.—Levi, A. Azione dell'acido gallico sul cuore isolato di rana. Arch. farm. sper., Roma, 1930, 61: 81-7.—Lloyd, W. I). M. Action of calcium on the isolated human fetal heart. J. Pharm. Exp. Ther., 1929, 36: 185-93.—Mathieu, F. Action du sulfate dc guanidine sur le rythme, la force contractile et la chronaxie du cceur isoie de grenouille. C. rend. Soc. biol., 1931, 106: 1237- 9.—Minamikawa, K. Ueber die Wirkung der Jod-undBrom- salze auf das isolierte Froschherz. Jap. J. Obst., 1932, 15: 129-37.—Reeves, H. G. The action of dl-glyceric aldehyde on the isolated heart. Q. J. Exp. Physiol., Lond., 1927, 18: 277-81.—Scheiner, H. Antagonisme cephaline-calcium sur le coeur isoie de grenouille. C. rend. Soc. biol., 1934, 115: 232- 5.—Simon, I. Dosi minime di svariati farmaci atte ad agire sul cuore isolato di rospo o di rana. Boll. Soc. ital. biol. sper., 1939, 14: 448.—Tanzi, B. Azione di alcuni composti arsenicali sul cuore isolato di mammifero; il contenuto lipidico, la desamina- zione, la glicolisi, l'attivit& meccanica del ventricolo sinistro nei cuore isolato di coniglio perfuso con Ringer-glicocolla- atoxyl. Arch. ital. sc. farm., 1937, 6: 122-34.—Untersteiner, L. Azione della dietilamide dell'acido 3-5 dimetilisooxazol-4- carbonico sul cuore di Rana isolato; azione su cuore valido. Boll. Soc. ital. biol. sper., 1939, 14: 340.—Volovik, 1. V. [Effect of congo-red upon the isolated heart of the frog when used for blocking the reticulo-endothelial svstem] Arkh. pat. anat., Moskva, 1940, 6: No. 6, 37-41—Zolnikova, N. K. [Effect of rapid and slow changes of concentration of calcium chloride and potassium chloride on the isolated heart of the frog] J. Phvsiol USSR, 1938, 25: 708-18. ---- lymphatic. For the lymphatic motor of Amphibia, arid Reptilia see Lymph heart. ---- Lymphatic vessels. Aliodi, F. Sulle vie linfatiche del fascio di His. Atti Accad. fisiocr. Siena, 1933, 11. ser., 1: 385-92, 3 pl.—Dolfini, G. E. Sulla presunta irrorazione linfatica dell'apparato di conduzione del cuore dei mammiferi; nota preventiva. Anat. Anz., 1939- 40, 89: 209-13.—Drinker, C. K.. Warren. M. F. [et al.] The flow, pressure, and composition of cardiac lymph. Am. J. Physiol., 1940, 130: 43-55.—Kampmeier, O. F. On the lymph flow of the human heart, with reference to the development of the channels and the first appearance, distribution, and physi- ology of their valves. Am. Heart J., 1928-29, 4: 210-22.— Patek, P. R. The morphology of the lymphatics of the mam- malian heart. Am. J. Anat., 1939, 64: 203-49, 7 pl.—Shore, L. ?™.,TJ1„e iymphatic drainage of the heart. J. Anat., Lond., 1927-28, 62: 125; 1929, 63: 291.—Trias, J. La injecci6 de les xarxes de Purkinje i dels limRtics de l'endocardi. Tr. Soc. biol., Barcel., 1917, 5: 191-204, 6 pl. ---- Malposition. See Heart, Dextrocardia; Heart, Displace- ment. ---- Measurement. See also Heart, Shape; Heart, Size; Heart, Surface area; Heart, Weight; also Heart chambers, Capacity. vrE5arHe^ J; A- & Kah'strom, S. C. Cardiac measurements. Aled Bull, \eterans Admin., 1937-38, 14: 16-9.—Benedetti, r\ ba grandezza, la forma e l'inclinazione del cuore in rapporto allacostituzionemdividuale. Endoer. pat. cost., Bologna 1934, n. ser., 9: 007-43.— Castellanos, I. ( 'ardiometrfa clfnica. Vida nueva, Habana, 1928, 22: 16 27,-Grober, J. Massenverhalt- msse des Herzens bei kimstlieher Arterienstarre. Verh. Deut. Kongr. m... Med.. 1907. 21: 446-52.—Kissane. R. W. Are.i of HEART 213 HEART the body surface and measurements of the normal heart in children; roentgen study. Arch. Int. M., 1930, 45: 241-7.— Leonard, B. W. The size and shape of the heart. Med. Ann. District of Columbia, 1935, 4: 162-6.—Marzocchi, G. II cuore della donna; studio costituzionale radiologico intro gruppi di soggetti normali dai 20 agli 80 anni. Ann. radiol., Bologna, 1940, 14: 69-104.—Moritz, F. Ueber die Norm der Grosse und Form des Herzens beim Mann und bei der Frau. Deut. Arch. klin. Med., 1931, 171: 431; passim.—Newcomer, E., & New- comer, N. B. Heart measurements. Radiology, 1936, 27: 521-32.—Poppi, A. Studio di biometria del cuore nei cadavere in condizioni normali e patologiche. Arch, pat., Bologna, 1938- 39, 19: 357-69.—Pruche, A. Les mesures en clinique circula- toire, leur technique, leur interpretation. Clinique, Par., 1928, 23: 272; 1929, 24: 25.—Sabena, V. La grandezza e la forma del cuore della donna sana in etk tra i 19 e i 25 anni. Radiol, med., 1935,22:53.------La grandezza, la situazione e la forma del cuore della donna sana in etk di 19-25 anni determinate secondo il metodo tridimensionale. Endoer. pat. cost., Bologna, 1936, 11: 3-33. ------ II cuore della donna sana in rapporto alia oostituzione morfologica individuale. Ibid., 457-74.—Trosller, I. S. A simple method of cardiometry. Radiology, 1927, 9: 75.—Wood, F. G. Cardiac mensuration. Lancet, Lond., 1935, 1: 1210-4. --- Measurement: Percussion. See also Heart, Silhouette. Asbeck, F. Grundsatzliches zur Herz- und Grenzperkussion. Deut. med. Wschr., 1934, 60: 1871-3.—Bojovsky, V. T. [Method of determining extent of cardiac dullness] Vrach. gaz., 1926, 30: 1165-8.—Cossio, P., & Dambrosi, R. G. Per- cusi6n del corazon. Dia med., B. Air., 1940, 12: 1042-7.— Cossio, P., & Martinez, F. Percusion del corazon controlada por el registro grafico de los ruidos de percusion. Rev. argent. card., 1938, 5: 1-24.—Dressier, W. Studies in physical diag- nosis of the heart; percussion. Brooklyn Hosp. J., 1941, 3: 196-208.—Estiu, M. Percusi6n cardfaca. Dia m6d., B. Air., 1928-29, 1: 615.—Gaussmann, F. O. [Diagnostic value of determination of the configuration of the heart by percussion] Klin, med., Moskva, 1929, 7: 1542-51.—Hunter, J. W. On the percussion of the heart. Virginia M. Month., 1926-27, 53: 665-70.—Jagic, N. Ueber Herzperkussion. Wien. klin. Wschr., 1927, 40: 1450.—Kirchner, F. Ueber die Tipp-Perkussion zur Bestimmung der relativen Herzdampfung nach Grgurina (Abbazia) Munch, med. Wschr., 1929. 76: 280.—hirsch, O. VVelche Art der Relativitat ist der Beurteilung der relativen Herzgrosse zugrunde zu legen? Jahrb. Kinderh., 1932, 3. F., 87: 185-211.—Kornblit, I. O. [Percussion of the heartl Vrach. gaz., 1926, 30: 1073-6.—Kurtz, C. M.. S 42:846-64. ---- Movability. Meng, R. *Ueber die Umslrllung des Herzens im Unterdruck bei Erhohung des Vorderkor pers liegend angeschnallter Kaninchen [Miinchen] p.27-31. 24^cm. Wurzb., 1938. Also Luftfahrtmedizin, 1938, 3: Bosco, G. El desplazamiento fisiclogico del corazon. Sem. med., B. Air., 1930, 37: pt 2, 1475-79.—Cossio, P., Berc.msky, I., & Casares, J. Desplazamiento del coraz6n en los decubitos laterales. Ibid., 1938, 45: 748-56.—Heckmann, K. Die Lageiinderungen des Herzens wahrend der Pulsation und ihr Ausdruck im Flachenkvmogramm. Fortsch. Rontgenstrahl., 1937, 55: 319-33.—Hoesch, K. Ueber die passi\e Beweglich- keit des normalen Herzens. Deut. med. Wsehr., 1935, 61 : 166-8.—Nathason, M. H. Electrocardiographic study of movements of the heart with change of posture Proc. Soc. Exp. Biol., N. Y., 1930-31, 28: 766-70.—Tartagli, D. Osser- vazioni sul comportamento del cuore nei passagsio dalla stazione eretta al decubito orizzontale con rifcrmenti alio costituzioni. Cuore & circol., 1931, 15: 458-64.—Vinogradov, A. I. [Mobility of the heart] Klin, med., Moskva, 1931, 9: 844. ---- Movability, abnormal [Cor mobile; Cor pendulum] Blackey, H. B. The drop heart. Internat. J. Surg., 1928, 41: 530-2.—Cedrangolo, E. Cardioplosi (M. di Rummo) Rass. ter. pat. clin., 1930, 2: 449-64.— Osawa, K. On cor mobile; frequency of its occurrence in apparently healthy persons. Gunidan zasshi, 1932, 229:2.—Osawa, S. Abnormal movability of the heart. Nature, Lond., 1933, 131: 241.— Secher, K. [Cor pendulum—gastroptosis— bathvgastrv] Bibl. lasger, 1932, 124: 223. Also Deut. Arch. klin. Med., 1932, 174: 341-51.—Stumpf, P. Was sind pathologische I lerzbe- wegungen? Zbl. inn. Med., 1935, 56: 177; 209. Vinogradov, A. P. [Rare case of moveable heart] Vrach. gaz., 1929, 3.3: 398-100. ---- Movement. See Heartbeat; Heart function; Heart muscle, Contraction. ---- Murmur. Sec under Heart sound. ---- Myocardium. Sec Heart muscle. ---- Neurosis. See Heart neurosis. ---- Percussion. See under Heart, Measurement. ---- Pericardium. See Heart-sac. ---- Pharmacology. See also Cardiotonics; Heart, Injection; Heart- beat, Regulation; also under names of anatomical parts of the heart as Heart auricle, Pharma- cology; also names of chemical substances and drugs as Anesthesia, Effects, cardiac; Digitalis, &c. Backman, L. E. *Bidrag till fragan om normala amnesomsattingsprodukters verkan pa hjarta och blodtryck. 282p. 8? Upps., 1912. Henruean, F. Le coeur; les medicaments cardiaques et l'electrocardiogramme. 252p. 25cm. Liege, 1926. Herrich-Schapfer, O. *Die Einwirkung von Phosphaten, Traubenzucker und Lezithin auf das Froschherz. 23p. 8? Konigsb., 1933. Jullien, A. *Des reactions comparees des cceurs de vertebres et d'invertebres vis-a-vis des electrolytes et des drogues [Lyon] 205p. 8? Trcvoux, 1936. Antonescu, C. V., & Bucheru, D. [Pharmacodynamic experimental investigations with chloride carbaminoil-choline- HEART 214 HEART doryl Merck; mechanism of cardiac action] Cluj. med., 1938, 19: 60S 12.— Baldassarre, E. C. Acci6n farmacodinamica de la folinerina sobre el corazon de la rana. Dfa med., B. Air., 1940, 12: 1022.- Blair, A. P., Hargreaves. C. ('., & Chen, K. K. Susceptibility of spadefoot toad and tree frog to ouabain, cvmarin, and coumingine hvdrochloride. Proc Soc. Exp. Biol., N. Y.. 1940. 15: 209-14.—Bouckaert, J. J.. Bouckaert, J. P., & Noyons, A. K. Rapport entre les effets des ions potas- sium et calcium et le coefficient de temperature du coeur de grenouille. Arch, internat. physiol., Liege, 1922, 19: 160-82 — lliirgi. S. Ueber die Wirkung einiger Pharmaka auf das I'r.-ivagusherz des Huhnerembrvos. Arb. Staatsinst. exp. Ther., 1936, H. 33, 1-38. Also Ausz.*Inaugur. Diss. Med. Fak. Univ. Bern 11.935-37) 1938, No. 27, 1.—Burridge, W. Experiments with acids. (}. J. Exp. Physiol., Lond., 1927, 18: 1-9.—Clark, A. J., Percival. G. H., & Stewart, C. P. Action of calcium ions on the frog's heart, J. Physiol., Lond., 1928-29, 66: 346-55 — Cohn, A. E.. & Macleod, A. G. The effect of acetyl-beta- incthylcholine on the frog's heart. Am. Heart J., 1939, 17: 305-15.—Coombs, H. C, & Pike, F. H. The action of inorganic salts and cardiac glucosides on the turtle heart. Am. J. Physiol., 1941, 133: 245.—Davenport, D., Loomis, J. W., & Opler, C. F. Notes on the pharmacology of the hearts of Ariolimax colum- bianus and Astacus trowbridgei. Biol. Bull., 1940, 79: 498- 507.—DeGraflT, A. C, Pan", G. H., & Lehman, R. A. The quantitative effect of 15 chemically related glycosides and genins on the embrvonic chick heart. J. Pharm. Exp. Ther., 1941, 72: 211-25.—Fiddes, J., Stokes, H. L., & Allason, S. E. The action of electrolvtes on the heart. Med. J. Australia, 1930, 1: 835-43.—Fredericq, H., Terroine, E. F. [et al.] Action cardiaque de quelques substances du groupe de l'aniline; aniline, toluidines, xvlidines. Arch, internat. physiol., Liege. 1922, 19: 352-68.—Frohlich, A., & Sole, A. Zur Wirkung der Alkalien auf das Herz. Arch. exp. Path., Lpz., 1926, 117: 322- 40.—Gelman, L, & Brown, S. The influence of several vasodi- latory substances (amylnitrite and histamine) on the basic functions of the heart of children, adults, adolescents and old people. Acta med. scand.. 1937, 92: 429-44.—Gilson, A. S., jr. Agents causing cardiac supernormality. Proc. Soc. Exp. Biol., N. V., 1939, 41: L- -Gomes da Costa, S. F. Equilibres loniques et pituitrine sur le cceur de grenouille; action du potassium. C rend. Soc. biol., 1927. 16: 879. Gramenitsky, M. I. [KITeei of hypertonic solutions on a heart, stopped by digitalis] J. I'hxsiol. USSR, 1938, 23: 146-8.—Guggenheimer, H., & Fisher, I. b. Ueber die Wirkung shirk verdiinnter Brom- verbindungen und anderer Anionen auf Herz- und Gefassystem. Verb. Deut. Ges. inn. Med., 1927, 39. Kongr., 162.—Hara, S. Beitrage zur Beohachtung iiber die Herzwirkung der ver- schiedenen Pharmaka; einige Versuche durch Elektrokardio- graphie der Tinte-Hegistrierung. Jap. J. M. Sc, 1939-40, 12: Proc. Pharm., 179. Hazama, F. Ueber die Wirkung der Jod-und Bromsalze auf das Froschherz. Kinki fujinka gakkai zasshi, 1926, 9: 1-19. Hill, W. T., & Myers, G. S. The effect of piperido-methyl-3-benzodioxane (933F) on the heart of the frog and the cat. Am. J. Physiol., 1939, 126: 305-9.—Inouye, S. The significance of the biological action of acids on the heart of the frog. Acta Scholae med. Univ. Kioto, 1924-25, 7: 227-40.—Jullien, A. Action du calcium et du magnesium sur le cceur de 1'huitre: antagonisine du potassium et des alcalino- terreux. ('. rend. Soc. biol., 1931, 108: 77-9.—Kahlson, G. Zur Frage der Herzwirkung von Kampfer, Cardiazol und Coramin nach Versuchen am sogenannten chemischen Alte- ra! ionsstrom. Skand. Arch. Physiol., Bed., 1938, 80: 209-13 — Kevdin. N. A. [KtTect of cation of calcium on the heart] Klin. med.. Moskva. 1926, 4: 55-6.—Kisch, B. Pharmakologie des Herzens. In Handb. norm. path. Physiol. (A. Bethe, G. Berg- man [et .-il.]) Berl., 1926, 8: T. 1, 712-862. ------ Die Saisonempfindlichkeit des Froschherzens gegeniiber Magne- siumsalzeu und Sauerstoffmangel. Arch. exp. Path., Lpz., 1928. 137: 116-28. ------ Zur Kenntnis der Wirkung verschiedener Ca-Salzkonzentrationen auf das Froschherz im Fruhsommer. Arch. ges. Physiol., 1928-29, 221: 469-73. ------ Antagonismus und Synergismus der Wirkung von Mg- und Ca-Salzen am Herzen. Ibid., 474-7. ------ Neuere Untersuchungen iiber die Wirkung der Salze zweiwertiger Kationen aufs Herz. Zschr. Kreislaufforsch., 1930, 22: 345- 54.—Kolda, J. Zur Frage der Herzwirkung von Chlorbarium und Bariomyl. Arch. wiss. prakt. Tierh., 1926-27, 55: 85- 107.—Kupcinskas, J. [Effect of calcium on the heart function] Medicina. Kaunas, 1939, 20: 1-19.— Kusnetzow, A. J. Ueber die Veranderung der Sensibilitat des isolierten Froschherzens zu kleinen Arecolindosen. Zschr. ges. exp. Med., 1925-26, 48: 334-41 —Loeper, M., Lemaire, A. [et al.l Action du sucre sur la resistance du coeur k quelques medicaments. C. rend. Soc. biol., 1935, 119: 367. Also Progr. med., Par., 1935, 1077.— Mancke, R. Untersuchungen iiber die Wirkung des Calcium- chlorids auf das Warmbluterherz. Arch. exp. Path., Lpz., 1930, 149: 67-75.—Marfori, P. Bases para la associaci6n de los farmacos cardiacos. Cron. med., Lima, 1940, 57: 152; 200.—Matsuura, Y. Influence of temperature upon the action of potassium chloride on the heart beats of Oryzias. J. Fac Sc. Univ. Tokyo, 1934, 3: sec. 4, 509-16.—Milella, A. Azione degli amino-acidi sul cuore di rospo in situ. Cuore & circol 1936, 20: 22-37—Mita, J. Zur Wirkung der Nichtelektrolyte aufs Herz. Arch. exp. Path., Lpz., 1926, 112: 17-21.—Moia, B., & Batlle, F. F. Los anaiepticos circulatorios; su acci6n farmacodinamica; sus aplicaciones. Rev. ardent card 1936- 37, 3: 457; 1937-38, 4: 37—Murakami, M. Vergleichende I ntersuchung iiber die Wirkung von Fruktose und Glukose auf die Herzfunktion. Jap. J. M, Sc, 1941, 14: Abstr. Pharm 5 — Murray. P. 1). F. Fibrillation in the chick embryo heart in vitro; ihe effects of excess potassium, calcium, magnesium and sodium, and of high and low osmotic pressures. Proc. R. Soc., Lond., 1934-35, ser. B, 116; 434 51. Nahum. L. H.. & Hon*. H. E. The effect of injection of monoiodoacetie acid and sodium cvanide on the mammalian heart. Am. .1. Physiol., 1931 35, 110: 56-60.—Paik, S. M. Zur Pharmakologie des japanischen Limulusherzens. Jap. J. M. Sc, 1934-35, 8: II. 3, Pharm., 160.-—Prosser, C. L., & Zimmerman, G. L. Comparative pharmacology of myogenic and neurogenic hearts. Biol. Bull., 1941, 81: 292.—Purkinje. Ueber die Wirkung gewisser Arznei- stoffe (personliche Erfahrungen) Camphor, Opium, Extract von rothem Fingerhut. Uebers. Arb. & Verand. SchleN. Ges. vaterl. Kult., Bresl., 1825, 56.—Raihii, C. E., Merikoski. M., & Nyman, A. Ueber die Einwirkung von Kalium und Kalzium auf das Herz. Skand. Arch. Physiol., Berl., 1933-34, 67: 211- 20.—Russo, G. Meccanismo dell'azione del citrato-jone sul cuore e sui muscoli lisci di anfibii. Boll. Soc. ital. biol. sper., 1935, 10: 798-801.—Sasaki, Y. Ueber die biologischen Ein- fliisse verschiedener kolloidaler Metalle; iiber den Einfluss derselben auf das Froschherz. Acta Scholae med. Univ. Kioto, 1928-29, 11: 335-64.—Sharapov, N. I., & Trutneva, A. [Influ- ence of Ca and K upon the effect of phenol upon (he frog's heart] Farm. & toks., Moskva, 1939, 2: No. 6, 26-31 — Spealman, C. R. The action of ions on the frog heart. Am. J. Physiol., 1940, 130: 792-38.—Viale, G. Action des sels de calcium sur le cceur. Arch. ital. biol., 1926, 76: 49-56.— Viciu, E. [Cardio-vascular action of analeptics] Cluj. med., 1938, 19: 676-83.—Zain, H. Die jahreszeitliche Schwankung der Magnesiumempfindlichkeit und des Phosphatidgehaltes von Esculentenherzen. Arch. exp. Path., Lpz., 1938, 190: 605-21. ---- Pharmacology: Methods of research. See also Heart, isolated; Heart muscle, Ex- plantation. Davydov, I. N., & Krol, N. G. [New methods in experi- mental investigation of reagents on the isolated frog's heart] J. Physiol. USSR, 1939, 27: 635. Erspamer, V. La titolazione farmacologica dei cardioeinetici nei colombi avilaminizzati ed ipervitaminizzati. Arch. farm, sper., 1939, 68: 151 -4.- Heubner, W., & Mancke. R. Ein Apparat fur vergleichende Untersuchungen am Warmbluterherzen in der Versuchsaii- ordnung nach Langendorlf. Arch. exp. Path., Lpz., 1928, 137: 257-63. ------ Methode fiir vergleichende pharmakologische Untersuchungen an Warmbluterherzen in der Anordnung nach Langendorff. In Handb. biol. Arbeitsmeth. (Abcrhaldcn, E.) 1935, Abt. V, T. 8, 885-904. ---- Physiology. See also various subheadings of Heart; Heart auricle; Heartbeat; Heart conduction; Heart function, &c. DeGraff, A. C. The normal and pathological physiology of the heart. Hosp. Social Serv., 1933, 28: Suppl. No. 2, 1-8, pl.—Eyster, J. A. E. Heart. Annual Rev. Physiol., 1939, 1: 317-44.—Fabre, P. Introduction de la notion hydraulique d'onde solitaire en cardiologie. C. rend. Soc. biol., 1926, 94: 149.—Foa, C. Vecchiee nuove nozioni sulla meccanica cardiaca. Med. ital., 1931, 12: 582-91.—Haberlandt, L. Neue For- schungsergebnisse der allgemeinen Herzphysiologie. Scientia, Bologna, 1930, 3. ser., 48: 148-52.—Hermann, H. Le coeur. In Traite physiol. norm. path. (Roger, G. H. & Binet, L.) Par., 1932, 6: 19-351.—Loewi, O. Kritische Bemerkungen zu L. Ashers Mitteilungen. Arch. ges. Physiol., 1926, 212: 695- 706.—Mendelsohn, M. Das Herz, ein sekundiires Organ. Med. Welt, 1927, 1: 80; 117; 154. Also Zschr. Kreislaufforsch., 1928, 20: 577-83.—Schott, E. Beobachtungen am gasgefulltcn Herzen; das Verhalten des nicht entbluteten Herzens bei Sauerstoffullung; Fullung mit verschiedenen Gasen. Deut. Arch. klin. Med., 1927, 155: 141-54—Somlo, P. Ueber die myogenen und neurogenen Eigenschaften des Herzens. Arch. exp. Path., Lpz., 1926, 113: 329-37.—Stephens, G. A. The heart and the way in which it is supported during life. Prac- titioner, Lond., 1929, 122: 287-97.—Venulet, F. Ammoniak und Saurebasengleichgewicht; zugleich iiber Siiurebasengleich- gewichtund Herztatigkeit. Klin. Wschr., 1936, 15: 1268-71 — Wiggers, C. J., & Green, H. D. Heart. Annual Rev. Physiol., 1941, 3: 313-42.—Zwaardemaker, H. La loi de la substitution equiradioactive et la sensibilisation. Arch, internat. physiol., Liege, 1921, 18: 282-95. ---- Physiology, comparative. See also Heart function. Clark, A. J. Comparative physiology of the heart. 157p. 8? Cambr., 1927. Bacq, Z. M. Observations physiologiques sur le coeur, les muscles et le systeme nervetix d'une ascidie (Ciona intestinalis) Bull. Acad. Belgique, 1934, 5. ser., 20: cl. sc, 1042-61 — Brunet, R., & Jullien, A. Quelques donn6es de base pour l'etude de la physiologie du cceur chez les mollusques. Ann. physiol., Par., 1936,12:664.—Burger, J. Vergleich der Empfind- lichkeit des Sinus-Vorhof-Apparates und der Kammer des Froschherzens gegen Aenderungen des Ionen-Milieus. Zschr. Biol., 1930, 90: 39-49.—Chauveau & Faivre, J. Experiences sur la physiologie du coeur faites k rEcoleiniperialev6terinaire HEART 215 HEART de Lyon. J. med. vet., Lyon, 1856, 12: 81-93.—Diederichs, W. Beitrage zur Physiologie des Muschelherzens. Zool. Jahrb., Abt. allg. Zool., 1935, 55: 231-80.—Endres, G., Matthews, B. H. C. [et al.] Observations on certain physiological processes of the marmot; the heart. Proc. R. Soc, Lond., 1930, ser. B, 107: 222-30, 2 pl.—Fredericq, H. Recherches experimentales sur la physiologie cardiaque d'Octopus vulgaris. Arch, internat. physiol., Liege, 1913-14, 14: 126-51.—Goor, H. van. Der Einfluss der Kohlensaureanhydrase auf das Herz des Siiuge- tieres. Acta brevia neerl., 1933, 3: 157.—Kakei, S. Experi- mentelle Studie an den Herzen des japanischen Limulus. Fukuoka acta med., 1933, 26: 33-7.—Kiilz, F. Zur Humoral- physiologie des Froschherzens. Arch. exp. Path., Lpz., 1928, 134: 252; 138: 135.—Lambert, R. K., & Rosenthal, A. H. The mechanical efficiency of the mammalian heart. Am. J. Physiol., 1927, 80: 719-31.—-Libbrecht, W. Le paradoxe cardiaque. Arch, internat. physiol., Liege, 1921, 16: 448-52.—Meyer, H. H. Ueber die Ionenwirkung auf das Selachier- und Teleostier- herz. Zschr. Biol., 1938-39, 99: 633-44.—Murata, T. Beitrage zur Physiologie des Vogelherzens. Fukuoka acta med., 1930, 23: 79-82.—Popper, M., & Russo, G. Sur Taction du sang humain defibrine sur le cceur de grenouille. J. physiol. path. gen., 1925, 23: 758-63.—Sole, A. Versuche iiber den Einfluss normaler und pathologischer menschlicher Harne auf das Kaltbliiterherz. Zschr. ges. exp. med., 1927, 56: 793-801 — Ten Gate, J. Beitrage zur Phvsiologie des Muschelherzens. Zschr. vergl. Physiol., 1929, 10: 309-16.—Wastl, H. Ueber photobiologische Desensibilisation am uberlebenden Frosch- herzen. Arch. exp. Path., Lpz., 1926, 114: 56-69. --- Poisoning. See under Heart muscle; Heart nerves. --- Ptosis. See Heart, Movability, abnormal. --- Pulsation. See Heartbeat. --- Radiography. See also Heart disease, Radiography; Medi- astinum, Radiography. Roesler, H. Atlas of cardiorocntgenology. 124p. 34 x 26cm. Springf. [1940] Abreu, M. de. Contribuicao ao estudo radiologico do mediastino na crianca; coracao; vasos da base. Fol. med., Rio, 1930, 11: 25; 37.—Allan, G. G. Radiologv of the heart. Proc. R. Soc M., Lond., 1931, 24: 1241-52.— Bohme, W. Ueber die Bedeutung moderner Rontgenverfahren fur die Physiologie und Pathophvsiologie des Herzens. Zbl. inn. Med., 1938, 59: 146-9.—Bordet, E., & Fischgold, H. Verification de la loi de Starling par la radiologic du coeur. Arch. mal. coeur, 1935, 28: 198-217.—Cossio, P. Cardiorradiologia. Dfa med., B. Air., 1931-32, 4: 169; 369.—Duran Arrom. Ortodioscopia, tele y radioquimografia. Internat. M. Blue Book, 1939, 10: 28-30 — Guilbert, C, & Frain. Les jalons de l'examen radiologique du coeur. Rev. med., Par., 1936, 53: 247-62.—Hardy, C. C. Roentgenology of the heart. Nebraska M. J., 1939, 24: 263 — Hodges, F. J. Roentgenological examination of the heart. Radiology, 1926, 7: 116-8.—Holmes, G. W. The examination of the heart and great vessels by means of the X-ray. Med. Clin. N. America, 1918, 1: 1197-214.—Jones, E., & Smithers, D. W. Radiology of the heart. S. Thomas Hosp. Gaz., Lond., 1938, 36: 412-21.—Laurel I, H. Rontgenologische Herzstudien. Upsala lak. foren. forh., 1928, n. F., 34: 495-589.— Ledbetter, L. H. Some aspects of cardioroentgenography. Texas J. M., 1936-37, 32: 748-52.—Lehmkuhl, H. Rontgenologische Untersuchungen des Herzens im Kindesalter. Jahrb. Kinderh., 1929, 3. F., 73: 66-79.—Lincoln, E. H., & Spillman, R. Studies on the hearts of normal children; roentgen-ray studies. Am. J. Dis. Child., 1928, 35: 791-810.—Margolies, A. X-ray of the heart and great vessels. In Cvclop. Med. (Piersol-Bortz) Phila., 1939, 3: 829-43.—Normal hearts by X-ray. J. M. Soc. N. Jersey, 1937, 34: 190.—Ortiz y Ramirez, T., & Martinez de Castro, J. La exploracion radiologica del corazon y el medico practico. Arch. lat. amer. card., Mex., 1934-35, 5: 1-9.— Perona, P. Lo stato attuale e gli odierni orientamenti della radiologia cardiaca. Atti Congr. ital. radiol. med., 1934, 11: No. 6, 5-191. Also Radiol, med., Milano, 1934, 21: 1439-41.— Post, J. W. The roentgenological study of the heart and great vessels as an adjunct to the internist. Hahneman. Month., 1925, 60: 170-6.—Roesler, H. The value of X-ray study of the heart. Week. Roster, Phila., 1938-39, 34: 82.—Rothstadt, L. E. The radiological examination of the heart. Med. J. Australia, 1938, 2: 116-22, pl.—Routier, D. Considerations generales sur la radiologic cardiaque. J. med. chir., Par., 1929, 100: 770-5.—Salotti, A., Palmieri, G. G. [et al.] Discussioni sulla relazione Perona e sulle comunicazioni inerenti a quel tema di relazione. Atti Congr. ital. radiol. med., 1934, 11: pt 2, 359-66.—Smithers, D. W. The X-ray examination of the heart. Postgrad. M. J., Lond., 1938, 14: 312-23, 2 pl — Sosman. M. Roentgen study of the heart. N. England J. M., 1931, 205: 80-3.—Teschendorf, W. Ueber Fortschritte auf dem Gebiet rontgenologischer Herzuntersuchung und -funk- tionsprufimg. Med. Welt, 1940, 14: 458; 475.—Wheeler, D. The radiological examination of the heart and great vessels. Canad. M. Ass. J., 1.929, 21: 189-95.—Zdansky, E. Rontgen- untersuchung des Herzens. Mitt. Volksgesundhamt., Wien, 1933 [Aerztl. Prax.] 171-3. ---- Radiography: Findings and interpretation. Bardy, A. *La perception du relief exact en stereoradiographie. 64p. 8? Par., 1933. Gallois, M. *Recherches sur l'orthodia- graphie du coeur de l'enfant, a l'etat normal et pathologique. 87p. 8? Lyon, 1935. Beretervide, E. A. Estudio radiologico del corazon en el nine Prensa med. argent., 1926, 13: 320-9.—Biehler. M. de. Signification diagnostique de l'orthodiagraphie. Arch. med. enf., 1938, 41: 495-514.—Brown, S., & Weiss, H. B. Lateral views of the heart and aorta. J. Am. M. Ass., 1927, 88: 226- 9.—Chantraine, H. Aufnahmespannung und Sichtbarkeit der Brustwirbel und Rippen im Herzschatten. Rontgenpraxis, 1934, 6: 469-71— Enquin, B., & Aguirre, J. A. Disociaci6n radiografica de la sombra mediastinal; visualizacion de la auricula izquierda en posicion frontal. Rev. argent, card., 1937-38, 4: 227-43.—Lehmkuhl, H. Beitrag zur Rontgenologic des kindlichen Herzens. Fortsch. Rontgenstrahl., 1928, 38: 696.—Lian, C, & Guenaux, G. Interpretation des images orthoradioscopiques du coeur (recherches experimentales et deductions pratiques) Paris med., 1927, 65: 473-85.—Maguire, L. M. Interpretation of roentgenograms of cardiac contours and measurements. Med. Bull. Veterans Admin., 1937-38, 14: 207-15.—Mentl, S. [Clinical value of radioscopic examination of the heart for hypotonia] Cas. lek. desk., 1930, 69: 1204-9.— Nemet, G. Some clinical aspects of radiology of the heart. Med. Clin. N. America, 1932, 15: 1383-407.—Periti, E. Modi- ficazioni deH'ortocardiogramma in seguito alia provocazione della stasi venosa degli arti. Riforma med., 1927, 43: 413-8.— Pichon, E. Interpretation medicale des resultats de l'examen radiologique du cceur. Sem. hop. Paris, 1932, 8: 197-206.— Rigler, L. G. The value and limitations of the roentgen examination of the heart. J. Lancet, 1933, 53: 127-9.—Saul, W. Verdichtungen im Herzschatten. Fortsch. Rontgen- strahl., 1932, 46: 450-7.—Tilk, G. TJ. Untersuchungen uber die Abhangigkeit des Gefiissbandschattens von der Thoraxtiefc. Zschr. Kreislaufforsch., 1937, 29: 2-17.—Trimani, A. La sombra triangular parapexiana. Prensa med. argent., 1938, 25: 512-30.—Zdansky, E. Rontgenbefunde am normalen Herzen. Wien. med. Wschr., 1927, 77: 1723-5. ---- Radiography: Methods and technique. See also Heart function, Roentgen kymography. Groedel, F. M. Die Rontgenuntersuchung des Herzens. p.593-760. 25Kcm. Miinch., 1934-38. Klason, T. *Om rontgenologisk under- sokning av hjartat med sarskild hansyn tagen till dettas horisontella omfang [Stockholm] 65p. 8? Bergen, 1924. Lamy, R. *Le point G etudie par les nouvelles methodes de radiologic cardiaque. 62p. 8° Par., 1933. Mathevet, J. J. *Etude radiologique du cceur de l'enfant par la methode de Vaquez- Bordet. 46p. 8? Par., 1931. Braunbehrens, von. Technik und Ergebnisse der Rontgen- untersuchung des Herzens. Fortsch. Rontgenstrahl., 1937, 56. Kongr., 17-9. Also Zbl. Gyn., 1937, 61: 1705.—Cavani, A. Una nuova proiezione per lo studio del contorno inferiore del cuore (proiezione xifo-toracica VI) Cuore & circol., 1940, 24: 85-90.—Danelius, G. Cross-sectional radiography of the heart. Radiology, 1939, 32: 190-4.—Forssman, W. Die Methodik der Kontrastdarstellung der zentralen Kreislauforgane. Arch. klin. Chir., 1931, 167: 787-90.—Gentile, N. Un nuevo aspetto nella radioscopia del cuore. Arch, radiol., Nap., 1927, 3: 1048- 54.—Grossmann, G. Tomographic (Theoretisches uber Tomographic) Fortsch. Rontgenstrahl., 1935, 51: 191-208.— Heckmann, K. Ein Verfahren zur Untersuchung der Pulsa tionen des Herzens und Organe mittels Rontgenstrahlen; ein Versuch zur Registrierung von Volumanderungen der Organe wahrend der Herzpulsation; vorlaufige Mitteilung. Klin. Wschr., 1936, 15: 13-6.—Jaubert de Beaujeu, A. Etude de l'image du cceur en O. A. G. 60? par la methode de Th. et Fr. Groedel (radiographic et eiectro-cardiographie synchrone) Bull. Soc. radiol. med. France, 1933, 21: 477-81, pl—Kohnle, H. Herzbild-Masstab fiir Rontgenaufnahmen. Rontgenpraxis, 1938, 10: 563-5.—Langley, R. W. Fluoroscopic study of the heart. Radiology, 1927, 8: 27-33.—Laubry, C, Cottenot, P. [et al.] Etude anatomo-radiologique du cceur et des gros vaisseaux par opacification. J. radiol. electr., 1935, 19: 193; passim.—Morrison, M. C. Cardiac roentgenoscopy. Canad. M. Ass. J., 1933, 29: 51-5.—Palmieri, G. G. Ueber meine Methode der plastischen Darstellung des Herzens am Lebenden, (Radioplastik) Acta radiol., Stockh., 1929, 10: 127-66. Sull'indagine radiologica del cuore in proiezione latero-laterale. Bull. sc. med., Bologna, 1939, III: 482-6.—Robb, G. P., & HEART 216 HEART Steinberg, I. Visualization of the chambers of the heart, the pulinonaiy circulation, and the great blood vessels in man; a practical "method. Am. J. Roentg., 1939, 41: 1-17.—Rousla- croix. A.. & Ray baud. A., fils. Radiographics du c Thoraxmittelschattens, insbesondere des Herzens und dei grossen Gefiisse. In Handb. biol. Arbeitsmeth. (Abderhalden. E.) Berl., 1927, Abt. 5, T. 4, 1503-80.—Hausman, F. O. [Is it necessai v to determine the configuration of the heart?] Vrach. delo, 1939, 21: 711-6.—Keith, T. S. The cardiac outline. Lancet, Lond., 1936, 1: 1466-8, 6 fig.—Kisaki, K. Die Analyse des Herzgefassrontgenschattens, besonders die Bestimmung der einzelnen Abschnitte an der Leiche. Acta Scholae med. Univ. Kioto, 1935-36, 18: 1; passim.—Lankford, J. S. A simple method of outlining the heart. Clin. M. & S., 1932, 39: 194. Mariupolsky, A. I. [Case of double contour of the cardio- vascular shadow] Vest, rentg., 1929, 7: 61-6.—Miller, H. M., & Gershon-Cohen, J. A comparative clinical and Roentgen studv of the heart borders. Med. Clin. N. America, 1929-30, 13: 909-21.—Perona, P., & Ottaviani, G. Contributo alio studio del margine cardio-vascolare destro. Arch, radiol., Nap., 1930, 6: 1079-1107.—Pfuhl, W. Die Herzoberflache und ihre praktische Bedeutung. Anat. Anz., 1929-30, 68: 20-38.—Spiller, U. Das Herzgesicht (Konfiguration) im Rontgenbild. Zschr. iirztl. Fortbild., 1936, 33: 612-4.—Wolf, A. Das frontale Herzbild als Mittel zur Beurteilung der Vergrosserung der einzelnen Herzabschnitte. Fortsch. Rontgen- strahl., 1932, 46: 275. ---- Silhouette: Measurement. See also Heart, Radiography: Orthodiagraphy; Heart, Size: Measurement. Frain, C. P. Contribution k l'etude radio- logique du cceur de la mensuration des diametrcs cardiaques. 61p. 8? Par., 1932. Rodovalho, O. A. *Contribuiea<> ao estudo das dimcnsoes normaes da stiperficie radiol6gica do coracao. 71n. 27^cm. S. Paulo, 1940. Alvarez Garcia, A. Sobre un metodo para evaluar Ion verdaderos diamctros del corazon en las radiografias ordinarias. Rev. As. med. mex., 1927, 6: 287-91— Bainton. J. H. The transverse diameter of the heart. Am. Heart J., 1932, 7: 331- 41- Bordet, E. Le diametre transversal du coeur. Prat, med, fr., 1931, 12: 3 7.—Castelli, G. La determinazione clinica dell'aia eardiaea; generality,; ricordi anatomo-topografici; ottusita assolutaerelativa; il metodo Orsi-Grocco (la percussione dell'orecchietta sinistra) il metodo fonendoscopico. Gior. med. prat., 192*. 10: 225; 260; 290. Chaumet. G. Expose d'une HEART 217 HEART methode d'interpretation des orthodiagrammes du coeur basee sur l'etablissement de quelques indices numeriques. J. radiol. electr., 1927, 11: 561-72. ------ Considerations critiques sur les mensurations de l'image radiologique du coeur; expose d'une methode personnelle. Arch. med. pharm. mil., 1928, 88: 867- 91 —Dehogues, M. El cuociente de cubicaci6n cardio-toracico. Vida nueva, Habana, 1930, 26: 605-21.—Dillon, J. G., & Gurewitsch, J. B. Hcrzmessungen in dorsoventralen und schriigen Durchmessern und ihre klinische Bedeutung. Fortsch. Rontgenstrahl., 1935, 51: 180-90.—Fray, W. W. Mensuration of the heart and chest in the left posteroanterior oblique posi- tion; a comparative study;relation of the transverse diameter of the heart to the thorax. Am. J. Roentg., 1932, 27: 177-86. ----- Comparison of the transverse diameters of the heart and the cardiothoracic indices of the chest obtained from the posteroanterior and left anterior oblique chest films. Ibid., 729-39.—Gordon, W., & Adams, W. Estimation of cardiac Iransverse diameter in children and comparison with cardiac area. Am. J. M. Sc, 1934, 1S8: 491-8—Gunsett, A., Magara- rhevitch, M., & Schneider, J. Les mensurations de l'aire r-ardiaque en position O. A. G. Bull. Soc. radiol. med. France, 1936, 24: 754-7.—Hammer, G. Die Herzflache als Masstab fiir die Herzgrossenbestimmung. Fortsch. Rontgenstrahl., 1928, 38: 1000-15.—Hodges, F. J., & Eyster, J. A. E. Estima- tion of transverse cardiac diameter in man. Arch. Int. M., 1926, 37: 707-14.—Hodges, P. C, Adams, W., & Gordon, W. ICstimation of cardiac area in children. Tr. Am. M. Ass., Sect, Pediat., 1933, 85-93. Also J. Am. M. Ass., 1933, 101: 914-6. Also repr.—Hudak, M. A. [Evaluation of diameters on the orthodiagram] Cas. lek. cesk., 1937, 76: 568.—Kahlstorf, A. Ueber Korrelationen der linearen Herzmasse und des Herzvolumens. Klin. Wschr., 1933, 12: 262-5.—Knoll, W. Herztransversaldurchmesser bei Skiliiufern. Arbeitsphv siologie, 1931-32, 5: 351-6.— Listov, A. F. [Diameters of the heart] Klin, med., Moskva, 1933, 11: 275-8.—Ludwig, H. Ront- genologische Beurteilung der Herzgrosse im zweiten schragen Durchmesser. Verh. Deut. Ges. Kreislaufforsch., 1938, 11: 356-63.—Mazeres, G. Sur la mensuration de l'aire cardiaque: application de la methode des quadratures de Chebichev. Arch, electr. med., 1919, 29: 72-5.—Oliveri, A. Le dimension! radiologiche del fascio cardiovascolare nelle etk fra i 3 ed i 17 anni. Radiol, med., Milano, 1935, 22: 608-16.—Rona, M., & Herrman, W. G. A new adaptation for cardiac measurement of the frontal silhouette. Radiology, 1934, 22: 721-38.—Skinner, E. F. The cardio-thoracic index; a clinical method of expressing the size of the heart. Brit. M. J., 1927, 1: 1053-5.—Stewart, H. J. A technique for measuring X-rav photographs of the cardiac areas of dogs. J. CUn. Invest., 1926-27, 3: 475-82. Ungerleide, H. E., & Clark, C. P. A study of the transverse diameter of the heart silhouette with prediction table based on the teleroentgenogram. Abstr. Proc. Ass. Life Insur. M. Dir. America, 1938, 25: 84-102, tab. Also Am. Heart J., 1939, 17: 92-102.—Van Buskirk. E. M. Graphical method for obtaining the area of the heart -hadowinthe roentgen-raystudy of heart disease. Radiology, 1935, 24: 433-7. --- Silhouette: Variation. Neugeborenen; uber das Rontgenbild des Herzens und den sog Inymusschatten. Okayama igakkai zasshi, 1936, 48: 237; pl. ---- Size [and volume] See also Heart, Measurement; Heart. Sil- houette: Measurement. Sem.mler, A. [R.] ^Untersuchungen iiber Grossenverhaltnisse von Herz und Lunge gegen- iiber Grosse, Lebend- und Schlachtgewicht bei zwei verschiedenen Schweinerassen [Bern] 54p. 8? Hannover, 1913. Barrett, J. H. The size of the living heart. Brit, J. Radiol 1937, 10: 47; 564.—Bedford, D. E., & Treadgold, H. A. The size of the healthy heart and its measurement. Lancet, Lond., 1931, 2: 836-42.—Blasius, W. Herzmasse im Rontgenbild. Fortsch. Rontgenstrahl., 1938, 57: 567-75, ch.—Dock, W. Heart rate and size; their importance to the physician. Med Insur., 1931, 47: 101; 128.—Giordano, G. Nuovi contributi critici e sperimentali alio studio clinico del volume del cuore. Riv. radiol., 1930, 2: 26-48.—Hesse, R. Die Grosse des Her- zens bei den Wirbeltieren. In Handb. norm. path. Physiol. (A. Bethe, G. Bergman [et al.]) Berl., 1926, 7: Teil 1, 132-40 — Liljestrand, G., Lysholm, E. [et al.] The normal heart volume in man. Am. Heart J., 1939, 17: 406-15.—Ludwig, H. Das Volumen des menschlichen Herzens. Radiol. Clin., Basel, 1939, 8: 213-23.—Moritz. Demonstration zur Grosse* und Fassungs- kraft des Herzens. Verh. Deut. Ges. Kreislaufforsch., 1928, 188.—Rothe, H. Die Grosse des Herzens und einiger anderer Organe (Leber, Milz Nieren) bei der grauen und weissen Hausmaus. Zool. Anz., 1933-34, 105: 281-6. ---- Size: Measurement. See also Heart, Measurement; Heart, Radi- ography: Orthodiagraphy; Heart, Silhouette. Fugmann, W. *Zur Beurteilung der Grosse des menschlichen Herzens; Untersuchungen zu dem von H. Rautmann angegebencn Korrelations- verfahren zur Bestimmung der orthodiagraphi- schen Herzgrosse [Freiburg] p.554-66. 8: Berl., 1927. Also Zschr. ges. Anat., 2. Abt., 1927, 13: Kahlstorf, A. *Ueber cine orthodiagraphi- sche Herzvolumenbestimmung [Wurzburg] p.123-46. 8° Lpz., 1932. Also Fortsch. Rontgenstrahl., 1932, 45: Benedetti, P. L'evaluation metrique individuelle du cceur (methode tridimensionnelle) Arch. mal. cceur, 1935, 28: 283 310. ■------ Bemerkungen zu der Arbeit von H. Ludwig iiber rontgenologische Beurteilung der Herzgrosse. Fortsch. Rontgenstrahl., 1939, 59: 602-7 [Erwiderung und Bemerkungen von H. Ludwig] 607.—Brun, B. Ricerche comparative sui metodi di cardiovolumetria sul vivente. Radiol, med., Milano, 1937, 24: 559-84.—Castex, M. R., & Beretervide, J. J. La medicion radioscopica del corazon. Prensa med. argent., 1925- 26, 12: 993-1001.—Chiostri, L. Studio critico di volumetria cardiaca con particolare riguardo al metodo dell'elissoide. Nuntius radiol., Siena, 1935, 3: 447-68, 6 pl.—Cignolini, P. Lo studio radiologico della volumetria cardiaca: proposto di un nuovo metodo e suo controllo anatomico. Cuore & circ, 1928, 12: 405-25.—Clagett, A. H., jr. Cardiac roentgenology; the value of exact cardiac measurements. Am. J. Roentg., 1941, 46: 794-7.—Comeau, W. J., & White. P. D. An evaluation of heart volume determinations by the Rohrer-Kahlstorf formula as a clinical method of measuring heart size. Am. Heart J., 1939, 17: 158-68.—Dedic, S. Die Ermittlung der propor- tionalen Herzgrosse. Fortsch. Rontgenstrahl., 1938, 57: 153- 67 —Eve, F. C. Measurement of the heart in angular degrees. Lancet, Lond., 1941, 1: 659-61.—Golst, L. L. [Roentgen measuring of the heart] Klin, med., Moskva, 1929, 7: 1552- 61 —Gosselin, J. Mensurations radiologiques cardiaques. Bull. Soc. med. hop. Quebec, 1934, 177-80.—Grassmann, K. Die Mamillarlinie, eine unbrauchbare Richtlinie fiir die Ab- schiitzung der Herzgrosse. Munch, med. Wschr., 1926, 73: 1474.—Hecht, A. F. Die Verwertung der orthodiagraphischen Herzflachenmessung fur die Beurteilung der Herzgrosse im Kindesalter; mit Beitragen zur Konstitution kreislaufkranker Kinder. Jahrb. Kinderh., 1931, 3. F., 83: 26-73.—Hodges, F. J. The clinical value of roentgen measurements of heart size. Radiology, 1933, 20: 161-4. ------ Determination of heart size. Am. J. Roentg., 1939, 42: 1-13.—Hofmann, H. Hori- zontes respecto a la medicion del volumen cardiaco. Dfa med., B. Air., 1931-32, 4: 695.—Hollaender, L. Die Bestimmung der Grosse'und Konfiguration des Herzens mittels Telediagraphie. Fortsch. Rontgenstrahl., 1927, 36: 1217-20.—Jonsell, S. A method for the determination of the heart size by teleroentgen- ography (a heart volume index) Acta radiol., Stockh., 1939, 20: 325-40.—Juda, A. Eine einfache Methode zur rontgeno- logischen Beurteilung der Herzgrosse. Deut. med. Wschr., 1926, 52: 956.—Kahlstorf, A. Moglichkeiten und Ergebnisse rontgenologischer Herzvolumenbestimmungcn. Klin. Wschr., 1938, 17: 223-5.—Keys, A., & Friedell, H. L. Measurement of Roxdorf, E. *Herzform und Lebensalter. 31|>. 22cm. Bonn, 1935. Anaya, E., & Caubarrere, N. El corazon en trapecio. Arch. urug. med., 1935, 7: 573-5.—Bakwin, H., & Bakwin, R. M. Body build in infants; growth of the cardiac silhouette and the thoraco-abdominal cavity. Am. J. Dis. Child., 1935, 49: 861-9. ------ Effect of retarded growth on the dimensions of the cardiac silhouette and the thoraco- abdominal cavity. Ibid., 870-5.—BenninghofT & Nitzschke. Kinematopograpische Vorfiihrung: Gestaltwechsel des Herzens in der Funktion. Monit. zool. ital., 1937, 47: Suppl., 231. Also Verh. Anat. Ges., 1937, 44: 155-7.—Brednow, W. Die Formveranderungen des schlagenden Herzens. Zschr. Kreislaufforsch., 1935, 27: 401-9.—Cassinis, U. Modificazioni della superficie cardiaca nei respiro normale, nell'inspirazione profonda, in riposo e dopo un lavoro muscolare. Boll. Soc. ital. biol. sper., 1931, 6: 67-70.—Herzum, A. Bedeutung haufiger Herzformen bei jugendlichen Sporttreibenden. Deut. med. Wschr., 1936, 62: Sonderausg. B, 28-31— Hollander, A. G., & Crawford, J. H. Unusual configuration of the heart in a child. Am. Heart J., 1940, 20: 762-8.—LofHer, W. Ueber Pseudo- konfigurationen des Herzens; extrakardial bedingte NachaL- mungen von Herzfehlerformen auf dem Leuchtschirm und im Rontgenbild. Deut. med. Wschr., 1934, 60: 108376— Muggia, A. Sul significato clinico di alcune modificazioni dell'area cardiaca nei bambini. Minerva med., Tor., 1930, 21: 783-6. Also Prat, pediat., Genova, 1930, 8: 179-85.—Ortiz y Ramirez, T. El ortocardiograma infantil. Arch. lat. amer. card., Mix., 1930-31, 1: 272-80.—Polland, B., & Krai, J. [Silhouette of heart in old athletes] Cas. 16k. desk., 1931, 70: 525-9 — Rouslacroix, A., & Raybaud, A. Recherches anatomo-radiologi- ques sur la constitution du bord inferieur du cceur apr£s pneu- moperitoine. Presse med., 1927, 35: 1010-2—Stumpf, P. Die Gestaltiinderung des schlagenden Herzens im Rontgenbild. Fortsch. Rontgenstrahl., 1928, 38: 1055-67.—Sussman, M. L. Cardiodynamics in relation to the analysis of the cardiac con- tour. Am. J. Roentg., 1936, 36: 854-67.—Verschuer, O. von, & Zipperlen. V. Die erb- und umweltbedingte Variabilitat der Herzform (nach Rdntgenfernaufnahmen des Herzens bei Zwillingen) Zschr. klin. Med., 1929-30, 112: 69-92.—Yama- moto, H. Rontgonphotographische Untersuchungen der I HEART 2IS HEART the heart size willi the roentgenkymogriph. Proc. Soc. Exp. Biol., N. Y., 1939. 40: 267-70.- -Ludwig, H. Rontgenologische Beurteilung der Herzgrosse. Fortsch. Rontgenstrahl.. 1939, .".9: 1; 139; 250. --Luton. S. Comparison of methods used for estimating the size of the heart. South. M. J.. 1930. 23: 6.81 - 9.— Moniz de Bettencourt, J. Etude des methodes radicdiigi- ques pour me.Mirer le coeur et les 2 ventricules dans la position oblique amen, ure gauche. Ann. med., Par., 1939, 45: 266- 93. Moritz, F. Zur Beuiteilung der Herzgrosse. Fortsch. Rontgenstrahl., 192S. 38: 993-9.------Die Beurteilung der Herzgrosse nach ilirer Knnelation zu sonstigen Abmessungen des Korpers. In Bain. & Balneother. Karlsbad (1930) 1931. 12: 3-22.- Plavinsky, J. V. [Determination of the heart size] Vrach. gaz., 1930, 34: 1033.—Sauer, E. Orthodiagrapliischc Herzvolumenbestinmiuiigen im Kindesalter. Zschr. Kinderh., 1934. 56: 116-21.- Schick. J. [Discount of orthodiagraphic variations in dimensions of the heart] Vrach. delo, 1928, 11: 111. —Size (The) of the heart as shown in the rnentgeimgiam. J. Am. M. Ass., 1936, 106: 227.—Sorokine, G. E. [Accurate measurements of the heart with the Roentgen ravs] Klin. med., Moskva, 1928, 6: No. 10. 587-93.—Spiller. Beurteilung der Herzgrosse im Rontgenverfahren. Zschr. arztl. Fortbild., 1936, 33: 467.—Stecher, W. R. Cardiac mensuration aided by horizontal orthodiagraphy. Am. J. Roentg., 1939, 42: 264- 75.—Stranqvist, M. [Method for determining the heart volume] Sven. lak. tidn., 1933, 30: [Sven. foren. inv. med. forh.] 337-9.—Sviridov, S. A. [Orthoscopic measurement of the heart volume with a ruler] Klin, med., Moskva, 1940, 18: No. 7, 143 5,—Tamiya, C. Ueber ein neues Prinzip fiir (■ rdssenbestimiuung des Herzens und seine praktische An- wendung. Fortsch. Rontgenstrahl., 1930, 41: 62-6.—Uspensky, A. E. [Determination of the projection surface and volume of the heart and its significance for clinical treatment] Ter. arkh., 1939, 17: No. 4, 8(1-92.—Weiss, K. Ueber Methqdik und Ergebnisse der rontgenologischen Herzgrossenbestimmung. Wan. klin. Wschr., 1933, 46: 1113-8.—White, P. D.. & Camp, P. I). A comparison of orthodiagraphic and teleroentgeno- graphie measurements of the heart and thorax. Ann. Int. M., 1932, 6: 469-81. ---- Size: Variation. See also Heart dilatation; Heart hypertrophy, &«. Dai m, H. *Die Schwankungen der Herz- grosse beim Normalen. 19p. 8? Bonn, 1937. Fismayer, G. Leber Tonus und Kinetik und deren Einfluss auf die (Inis.se und Dvnamik des Herzens im muskelkraftigen und muskclscliwachen Zustand. Erg. Physiol., 1930. 30: 126 52. Eyster. J. A. E. The size of the heart in the normal and in organic heart disease. Radiology, 1927, 8: 300-6.— Goldschmid. E. Grosse und Gewicht des Herzens unter normalen und pathologist-hen Verhaltnissen. In Handb. norm. path. Physiol. (A. Bethe, G. Bergmann [et al.]) Berl., 1926, 8: T. 1, 141-57.— Haug, K., & Jaenisch, R. Ueber experimentell erzeugte akute Veranderungen der Herzgrosse beim Menschen. Zschr. klin. Med., 1930, 114: 773-84.—Hemingway, A., & Fee, A. R. The relationship between the volume of the heart and its oxygen usage. J. Physiol., Lond., 1927-28, 63: 299-303 — Minerbi, C Gli effetti degli atteggiamenti forzati del capo sul volume dei vari segmenti cardiaci. Riforma med., 1926, 42: 1210.—Nylin, G.. Sallstrom, T., & Agren, O. Physiologische und pathologische Herzvolumenschwankungen. Verh. Deut. Ges. Kreislaufforsch., 1939, 12: 369-82.—Rautmann, H. Untersuchungen iiber die Variabilitat der Herzgrosse. Verh. Deut. Ges. inn. Med., 1926, 38. Kongr., 316-20. ------ & Heiss, F. Zur Kenntnis der korrelativen Variabilitat der orthodiagraphischen Herzgrosse. Zschr. ges. Anat., 2. Abt., 1927-28. 13: 567-74.—Samsonov, V. V., & Beier, V. A. [De- pendence of the dimensions of the right heart on the height of the diaphragm with regard to relative renal dullness] Vrach. gaz., 1929, 33: 365-72.—Schlomka, G., & Broich, W. Ueber die phvsiologischen Schwankungen der Herzgrosse. Arch. Kreislaufforsch., 1937,1:384-404.—Schlomka, G., & Daum, H. Ueber die Spontanschwankungen der Herzgrosse beim Gesun- den. Fortsch. Rontgenstrahl., 1937, 55: 558-69. ---- Size: Variation: Age. Beneke, F. W. Ueber das Volumen des Herzens und die Weite der Arteria pulmonalis und Aorta ascendens in den verschiedenen Lebensaltern. 56p. 4? Cassel. 1879. Pfister, R. *Herzmasse (Gewicht, Grosse, Volumen) als Funktion des Alters. 31 p. 21cm Miinch. [1936] Voss, E. *R6ntgenographische Grossenbe- stimmungen des Herzens im Sauglings- und Kleinkindesalter [Kiel] p.428-36. 8? Berl 1929. Also Zschr. Kinderh., 1929, 48: Bernuth, F. von. Zur Beurteilung der Herzgrosse des Kindes nach dem Rontgenbild. Mschr. Kinderh., 1930, 48: 2.5-9. Also Fortsch. Rontgenstrahl., 1930, 42: 368-71 Also Erg. inn. Med. Kinderh., 1931, 39: 69-142.—Bollini. V. La determinazione radiologica delle dimensioni del cuore in 300 rnaschi ventenni. Radiol, med., Milano. 1933, 20: 1021-82.— Honda. M. Ueber die Herzgrosse bei nlten Lcuten. Okayama igakkai zasshi, 1934, 46: 11.—Joscphi, M. G. Measurements of the size of the heart m normal children; a statistical study. Am. J. Dis. Child., 1935. 50: 929-44.—Kirsch, O. Ortho- diagraphische Herzgrossenbeui teilung im Kindesalter. Klin. Wschr., 1930, 9: 1.V7-I 6. Kloiber, H., & Stroomann. <;. Dag Rontgenbild des alternden Herzens. Fortsch. Rontgenstrahl.. 1929, 39: 993-1015.—Maresh, M. M., & Washburn, A. H. Size of the heart in healthy children; roentgen measurements of the cardiac area and transverse diameter for 67 children between birth and the age of 6 years. Am. J. Dis. Child., 1938, 56: 33-60.—Marzocchi. G. La grandezza, la variability e le correlazioni del cuore nella puberta. Radiol, med., Milano, 1938, 25: 436-53.—Minkin, S. L., & Svetlova. O. I. [Sizes and certain questions of internal architecture of the heart in infants] Sovet. pediat, 1935, No. 12, 12-7, pl—Olivo, O. M. Accresci- mento del cuore in animali di mole corporea differente. Monit. zool. ital., 1932-33, 43: Suppl., 162-5.—Orlandini. L. La grandezza del cuore nei vecchi; studio ortodiagrafico. Riv. radiol., 1932-33, 7: 427-42— Perrin, P., & Mathevet, J. Les dimensions du crxur chez l'enfant; etude radiologique. Arch. mal. cceur, 1931, 24: 106-13.—Sabena, V. La grandezza ortodiagrafica del cuore della donna sana di 19-25 anni. Bull. sc. med., Bologna, 1934, 106: 293.—Urban, N. Untersuchungen iiber die Herzgrosse bei 9-15jahrigen Knaben unter Beriick- sichtigung ihrer Beanspruchung im Jungvolkdienst. Mschr. Kinderh., 1939, 79: 91-111.—Ziskin, T. Further studies on the development and size of the heart in children. J. Lancet, 1927, 47: 18. ---- Size: Variation, circulatory. Crisler, G., & van Liere, E. J. The effect of the vagus on the diastolic size of the heart and its bearing on the question of cardiac tonus. Am. J. Physiol., 1931, 98: 585-8.—Eismayer, G., & Quincke, H. Ueber das Volum des tatigen Herzens am Ende der Diastole. Arch. exp. Path., Lpz., 1929, 140: 340-54 — Lamport, F. M. [Effect of cardiac desympathization upon the form and size of the heart] Sovet. khir., 1932, 3: 38-4(1. I.uchinin. V. A. [Action of limanotherapy on dimensions of tin heart of vagotonics] Vrach. gaz., 1926, 30: 575-9.—Mahaim, I. Des variations des l'indice de profondcur dans les reactions volumetriques du cceur. Ann. med., Par., 1926, 20: 73-80.— Peserico, E. The influence of mechanical factors of the circu- lation upon the beartvolume. J. Physiol., Lond., 1928-29, 65: 146 50. Rosier, H. Rontgenologische Untersuchungen iiber die Herzgrosse bei Herzsclilagverlangsaiiiung. Fortsch. KonlgenstraliL, 1929,40:519-22. Strughold, H. A cinemato- graphic study of systolic and diastolic heart size with special reference to the effects of anoxemia. Am. J. Ph\siol., 1930, 94: 641-55. ---- Size: Variation: Exercise. See also Exercise, Physiology, cardiovascular. Bruns, O. Herzgrosse und Muskelarbeit. Erg. inn. Med. Kinderh., 1928, 34: 201-19. ------ Welche Umstande und Vorgange beeinflussen die Herzgrosse des Sportsmannes'.' Deut. med. Wschr., 1936, 62: Sonderausg. B, 25-7.—Burla- chenko, U. A. [Roentgen examination of the heart in physical exertions] Vrach. delo, 1937, 19: 687-94.—Deutsch. F." Die Herzgrossenschwankungen, speziell die Diminutio cordis, unmittelbar nach sportlichen Leistungen. Arbeitsphysiologie, 1929-30, 2: 215-32. ------ Die Sportherzverkleinerung, Med. Klin., Berl., 1929, 25: 628-30.—Elektorowicz, A.. & Reicher, E. [Dimensions and the functional capacity of the heart in sportsmen, after exertion] Polska gaz. lek., 1927, 6: 772.—Fabre, R., & Liard, J. Les modifications du volume du coeur pendant l'efTort. Ann. physiol., Par., 1938, 14: 524 9. Fahr, G., Wangensteen, O., & Sperling, S. Effect of forced exercise on size of heart in normal and pericardiotomized dogs. Proc. Soc. Exp. Biol., N. Y., 1929-30, 27: 454.—Gotthardt, P. P. Herzgrossen bei Meistern im Sport. Fortsch. Rontgen- strahl., 1938, 58: Tagungsh., 131.—Guardabassi, L. Ricerche sulla valutazione morfologica del cuore con metodo radiologico tridimensionale nei cultori dello sport. Radiol, med., Milano, 1937, 24: 843-69.—Hannisdahl, B. [Roentgen investigation of changes in heart size in skiers] Norsk, mag. laegevid., 1938, 99: 71-93, 4 pl.—Herxheimer, H. Die Herzgrosse der Amster- damer Olympiadeteilnehmer. Klin. Wschr., 1929, 8: 402. ------ Untersuchungen iiber die Aenderung der Herzgrosse unter dem Einfluss bestimmter Sportarten. Zschr. klin. Med.. 1929, 111: 376-89, 4 pl.------ Wachstum jugendlicher Herzen durch sportliche Anstrengung. Med. Welt, 1933, 7: 695.—Herzum, A. [Determination of the size of the heart in young sportsmen] Budapesti orv. ujs., 1938, 36: 637-45. Also Orv. hetil., 1937, 81: 1223-6. Also Zschr. Kreislaufforsch., 1938, 30: 197-204.—Kahlstorf, A. Das Volumen des Herzens unter dem Einfluss korperlicher Arbeit. Verh. Phvs. med. Ges. Wurzburg, 1931, n. F., 56: 103.—Kaplunowa. I). Der Einfluss physischer Arbeit auf die Herzgrosse. I'orlschr. Rontgenstrahl., 1929, 40: 816-21.—Knoll, W., Thorner, W.. & Kaufmann, W. Die Beeinflussung der Herzgrosse durch Arbeit und Sport. Med. Welt, 1933, 7: 1345-8.—Krai. J. [Heart volume at various ages among the Sokols (athletic association) executing regular exercises] Cas. hlk. desk., 1939, 78: 982 6. ------ & Polland, B. [Contraction of the heart aflor .sportsl HEART 219 HEART Ibid., 1934, 73: 541-3. Also Fol. med., Nap., 1936, 22: 195- 201.—Liljestrand, G., Lysholm, E., & Nylin, G. The immediate effects of muscular work on the stroke and heart volume in man. Skand. Arch. Physiol., Berl., 1938, 80: 265-82.—Muller, E. A. Herzarbeit und Herzvolumen. Arch. ges. Physiol., 1936-37, 238: 638-43.—Muller, W. Untersuchungen uber die Herz- grosse bei Rennruderern. Zschr. ges. phys. Ther., 1925, 30: 154-62.—Ohga, K. Ueber die Einfliisse der Leibesiibungen auf die Grosse und Form des Herzens, besonders beim Eishockey- sport. J. Orient. M., Dairen, 1940, 32: 10-2.—Podkaminski, N. A. Les etudes sur l'influence de quelques phenomenes professionnels sur les dimensions du cceur. Arch, ilectr. med., 1931, 39: 236-8.—Rautmann, H. Muskelarbeit und Herzgrosse. Klin. Wschr., 1927, 6: [Sportarzt. Mitt.] 13-5. ------ Ueber die Wirkung maximaler Muskelarbeit auf die Herzgrosse. Munch, med. Wschr., 1928, 75: 1528.—Roesler, H. A roent- genological study of the heart size in athletes. Am. J. Roentg., 1936, 36: 849-53.—Schieffer. Ueber den Einfluss der Berufs- arbeit auf die Herzgrosse. Deut. Arch. klin. Med., 1908, 92: 383-91.—Zdansky, E. Ueber die Veranderungen der Herz- grosse und -Form nach einmaliger Arbeitsleistung. Zschr. klin. Med., 1936-37, 131: 112-31. ---;— Aenderungen der Grosse und Form des Herzens nach einer einmaligen Arbeits- leistung. Fortsch. Rontgenstrahl., 1937, 56: 22. --- Size: Variation: Heredity and environment. Spycher, C. *Rontgenographische Unter- suchung der menschlichen Herzmasse bei stark vermindertem Luftdruck. p.390-400. 8? Zur., 1931. Also Arbeitsphysiologie, 1931, 4: Bezza, P. Le dimensioni del cuore, dell'aorta e delle arterie iliache comuni determinate sopra 100 individui adulti d'ambo i sessi della provincia di Perugia e confrontate con quelle di altrettanti individui della provincia di Parma. Endoer. pat. cost., Bologna, 1935, n. ser., 10: 12-36; 4 tab.—Breitman, M. J. [Determination of normal size of the heart in relation to certain characteristics of the constitution] Klin, med., Moskva, 1932, 10: 525-9.—Comeau, W. J.. & White, P. D. Body build and heart size; a study of 20 pairs of identical twins and 15 pairs of unrelated individuals with similar bodv height and weight. Am. Heart J., 1939, 17: 616-23.—Gurewitsch, J. B. Die Rolle der Vererbung und der Umwelt in der Variabilitat der Herzgrosse; Untersuchungen an 193 Zwillingspaaren. Fortsch. Rontgenstrahl., 1936, 54: 62-8. Also Proc. Maxim Gorkv Med. Genet. Res. Inst., Moskva, 1936, 4: 353-69.— Stieve, H. Untersuchungen an Wirbeltierherzen; der Einfluss des Aufent- haltes in hohen Lagen auf die Herzgrosse ciniger Vogelarten. Zool. Anz., 1932-33, 101: 233-46. ------ Ueber den Einfluss der Umwelt auf die Grosse des Herzens. Med. Klin., Berl., 1938, 34: 5; 42.—Tsuchiya, S. Ueber die Grosse und das Tlewicht des Herzens bei den japanischen Zwillingsfeten. Okajimas fol. anat., 1938, 16: 279; 1939- 18: 81. --- Size: Variation: Pregnancy. Rohlfing, W. [H. L.] *Der Einfluss korper- licher Arbeit auf die Herzgrosse bei Schwangeren. 24p. 8? Bonn, 1933. Bustos Moron, R., & Lanari, E. L. Modificaciones del tamano y de la posici6n del corazon durante el embarazo. Prensa med. argent., 1928. 14: 877-88.—Clauser, F. Orto- diagrafia e costituzione nella puerpera (nota preventiva) Clin. ostet., 1927, 29: 190-9.—Cova, E. II volume e la topografia del cuore in gravidanza studiati mediante la radioscopia. Atti Soc. ital. ostet., 1911, 16: 405.—Maislisch, R., & Bobrezkaja, W. Ueber die Grosse des Herzens der Schwangeren. Fortsch. Rontgenstrahl., 1936, 54: 574-9. --- Sounds. See Heart sound. --- Surgery. See also Angina pectoris, Treatment; Coronary arteries, Collaterals: Surgery; Heart, Injury: Treatment; Heart disease, Treatment; Thorax, Surgery. Frey, E. K. Die Chirurgie des Herzens. 278p. 26^cm. Stuttg., 1939. King, E. S. J. Surgery of the heart. 728p. 24cm. Lond. [1941] Wohlauer, V. *Pathologisch-physiologische Grundlagen der Chirurgie des Herzens [Berlin] 27p. 23#cm. Charlottenb., 1937. Aievoli, E. Saggi di odierna chirurgia cardiopericardiale. Gazz. internaz. med. chir., 1935, 45: 509-14.—Alessandri, R. Chirurgia del cuore e dei grossi vasi. Rapp. Congr. Soc. internat. chir., 1921, 139-241.—Allison, P. R. Surgery of the heart. Nurs. Times, Lond., 1938, 34: 916-8.—Ascoli, M. Chirurgia del cuore. In Manuale chir. (Alessandri, R.) 1934, 2: pt 2, 361-74.—Beck, C. S. The operative story of the heart. Ann. I rt & 192A£: 224iiV, ~a---■ ,Surgery of the Pericardium, the heart and the great blood vessels. In Pract. Libr M & S (Appleton) 1933, 4: 240-309. ------ Recent advance* m iYiTkZ surgery- Tr- Kansas City Acad. M. (1935-37) 1937 tv 7 • 1 7WT lThe,JjSart as a surgical organ. Med. Ann! District of Columbia, 1936, 5: 29-36.------ Surgery of the heart and pericardium. In Diagn. Treat. Cardiovasc. Dis. (Stroud, W. D.) Phila., 1940, 2: 1145-84. ------. Surgerv of the heart. Week. Bull. S. Louis M. Soc, 1940-41, 35: 238- 42.—Ceccarelli, G. Prolusioni; cuore e chirurgia; c'onquiste e problemi. Pohchnico, 1940, 47: sez. prat., 477-92—Cutler E fnQQTi?? VJn^ status of cardiac surgery. Surg. Gyn. Obst., 1932, 54: 274-9. —--- First surgical operation on the heart. J. Am. M. Ass., 1936, 106: 725.—Elkin, D. C. Emergency surgery of the heart. Am. J. Surg., 1939, 46: 551-61. _____- The special field of cardiac surgery. J. M. Ass. Georgia, 1941, 30: 377-86.—Farina, G. Contributo alia chirurgia cardiaca] Gazz. med. Roma, 1930, 56: 102-6.—Feil. H., & Rossman, P. L. Electrocardiographic observations in cardiac surgerv Ann. Int. M., 1939-40, 13: 402-14. Also Mod. Concepts Card' Dis., 1940, 9: L—Fischer, H. Fortschritte auf dem Gebiete der Thoraxchirurgie: Herzbeutel und Herz. Zbl. Chir., 1935, 62: 1228-37.—Funck-Brentano, P. La chirurgie du cceur J med. chir., Par., 1940, 111: 92-101.—Gay. J. G. Surgery of the heart. South. Surgeon, 1936, 5: 67-9.—Gentil, F. Notes sur la chirurgie cardiopericardique. Lisboa med., 1933,10:391-413.— Goodman, C. Surgery of the heart; blood-vessels; thrombosis and embolism and blood transfusion. Rapp. Congr. Soc. internat. chir., 1921, 243-80.—Guidone, P. La chirurgia cardiaca con presentazione di un operato. Arch. Soc. ital. chir. (1921) 1922, 28: 229-33.—Hanson, K. B. Surgery of the heart. J. Med., Cincin., 1936-37, 17: 559-61.—Harpole, J. Surgery of the heart; a revolution. In his Leaves [etc.] Lond., 1937, 133-45.—Jentzer, A. Chirurgie du cceur. P. verb. Congr. fr. chir., 1932, 41: 302-7.—Lenormant, C. La chirurgie du cceur (traumatismes exceptes) Vie med., 1932, 13: 983-6. ------ & Leriche, R. La chirurgie du cceur (traumatismes exceptes) J. chir., Par., 1932, 40: 491-4. Also Presse med., 1932, 40; 1510.—Lockwood, A. L. Surgery of the pericardium and heart. Arch. Surg., 1929, 18: 417-74.—Mansell, H. E. Recent advances in cardiac surgery. Nurs. Times, Lond., 1938, 34: 1303-6.—Mautz, F. R. Applied physiology in surgery of the heart. Current Res. Anesth., 1941, 20: 207-11.—Moreno Canas, R. Apuntes sobre cirugia cardiaca. Mem. Congr. med. centroamer., 1934, 2. Congr., 113-22, 3 pl.—New (The) physi- ologic surgery on the heart. J. Am. M. Ass., 1941, 117: 452.— Nissen, R. Einige allgemein interessierende Fragen aus der Chirurgie des Herzens. Schweiz. med. Wschr., 1937, 67: 861- 5. Also Internat. med. W. Schweiz (1937) 1938, 3. Congr., 263-78 [Discussion] 308-11.—O'Shaughnessy, L. The surgery of the heart. Practitioner, Lond., 1938, 140: 603-18. Also Newcastle M. J., 1939, 19: 61-73. ------ Future of cardiac surgery. Lancet, Lond., 1939, 2: 969-71.—Patek, A. J. The heart in surgery. Wisconsin M. J., 1935, 34: 386-90.—Pezzi, C. A propos de la chirurgie du coeur. P. verb. Congr. fr. chir., 1932, 41: 228-32.—Pool, E. H., & Semsroth, K. Repair of a heart wound. Tr. South. Surg. Ass. (1925) 1926, 38: 219-29, 3 pl.—Quervain, F. de. Discussion du rapport sur la chirurgie du cceur. P. verb. Congr. fr. chir., 1932, 41: 317-22.—Red (The) light of Mackenzie. Lancet, Lond., 1938, 2: 837.— Ritchie. A propos de la chirurgie du cceur. P. verb. Congr. fr. chir., 1932, 41: 226-8.—Sauerbruch, F., & O'Shaughnessy, L. Surgery of the heart. West London M. J., 1938,43:17-30 — Shipley, A. M. The operative approach to the heart and peri- cardium. Surg. Gvn. Obst., 1932, 54: 280-9.—Sonntag, E. Chirurgie des Herzens. Med. Welt, 1931, 5: 1269-72.— Surgery of the heart. Rep. M. Res. Counc, Lond. (1936-37) 1938, 22-5.—Turner. La chirurgie du coeur. Rapp. Congr. Soc. internat. chir., 1921, 5-75.—Vaquez, H. A propos de la chirurgie du coeur. P. verb. Congr. fr. chir., 1932, 41: 264-9.— Vaquez, M. Chirurgie du cceur. Bruxelles med., 1932-33, 13: 554-8. ---- Surgery: Methods. Bagrov, I. B. [Cases of operation in injuries of both ventricles and intraventricular septum] Vest, khir., 1929, 17: 150.— Beck, C. S. The development of a new blood supply to the heart by operation. Ann. Surg., 1935, 102: 801-13. Also Ohio M. J., 1936, 32: 113-7. ■---■— Further data on the establishment of a new blood supply to the heart by operation. J. Thorac. Surg., 1936, 5: 604-11.—Bellet, S. Artificial pro- duction of an accessory circulation of the heart muscle. In Cyclop. Med. (Piersol-Bortz) Phila., 1939, 3: 773.—Birt, E. Kurzer Beitrag zur Herz- und Fremdkorperchirurgie. Zbl. Chir., 1928, 55: 3154-7.—Campeanu, L. Das Aufheben der Herzbewegung und das Wiederbeleben des Herzens wahrend der Herzoperation. Proc. Internat. Physiol. Congr. (1935) 1938, 15. Congr., 437-9.—Cherevkov, P. S. [Types of venous blood supply to the heart in relation to surgery of the veins of the heart] Vest, khir., 1930, 20: 709-16.—Condorelli, L. Su una nuova tecnica operatoria per cardiologia sperimentale. Bol. Soc. ital. biol. sper., 1927, 2: 901-3.—Dmitriev, I. P. Experimentelle Beitrage zur Frage uber den operativen Zugang zu den Herzklappen und der Vorhofsscheidewand (vorlaufige Mitteilung) Zbl. Chir., 1926, 53: 715-8—Grekov, 1. I. [Exploratory ventriculotomy] Vest, khir., 1929, 16-17: 26- 33.—Griffith, G. C, & Bates, W. Heart surgery; a ventricular perforation in transplanting a new blood supply. Internat. Clin., 1938, n. ser., 2: 17-28, 4 pl.—Gross, L., Blum, L., & HEART 220 HEART Silverman, C. Experimental attempts to incicaM- the Mood suppl to the dog's heart bv means of coronary -itivi- occlusion J. I \p. M 1937. 6.>: 91-108, 2 |il. Also repr.- Hcinberker. P., & Barton. \V. A. An effective method for the development of collateral circulation to the myocardium. Ann. Surg., 1941, 114: 186-90. Lenormant. C. La thoracectomie precoidiale lans les cardiopathies autres que la s.vmphyse du p6rrcarde. Hull. Acad, med., Par., 1932, 3. ser., 107: 978-85 — Lockwood, •\. L. Beck operation (heart) report of 2 cases. J. Thorac. Suig., 1938-39. 8: 59H 606.—Malmejac, J. Sur un artifice experimental qui facilitc l'ecrasement opSratoire du faisceau de His selon la technique de L. Fredericq. C. rend. Soc. biol., 1931, 107: 166-8. Mautz, F. R. Reduction of cardiac irri- tability by the epicardial and systemic administration of drugs as a protection in cardiac surgery. J. Thorac. Surg., 1936, 5: 612 '8 Nissen, R. Die Resektion aus dem Brustbeine zur Ireilegung des Herzens. Deut. Zschr. Chir.. 1930, 229: 144 — O'Shaughnessy, L. Slome, D., & Watson, F. Surgical revas- cularisation of the heart; the experimental basis. Lancet, Lond., 1939. 1: 617-21. Also repr.—Pruche, A. A propos de I'operation de O'Shaughnessy ou cardio-omentopexie; indica- tions et contre-indications; importance de l'eiectro-cardio- ■mamine dans leur determination. Bull. Soc. med. Paris, 1938, ^18 22 Ramirez I.opez. E. I'n tecnica personal para abordar el corazon. Hev. nr. Ilo-p. Juarez, M6x., 1937, 8: 29-36 — Rouslacroix, A. Indications de la thoracectomie precordial (operation de Brauen Maiseillc med., 1926, 63: 667-75 — Stanton. E. J., Schildt, P.. tv Beck. V. S. The effect of abrasion of the surface of the heart upon intew-oroiiury communications. Am. Heart J.. 1941, 22: 529-38.—Stocker, H. Zur Chirurgie tier Herzverletzungen und Entstehung der Ihi/.tamponade. Wien. klin. Wsehr., 1931 44: 477-9. ---- Surgery: Suture. See also Heart, Injury. Lindemann, F. \V. *Dau(Trosultate nach Herznaht bei Schuss- und Stich verletzungen [Kicll 16p. 8? \Yuppertal-Elberfeld, 1931. Angeli, A. Un caso feliee di sutura del cuore per ferita da pallottnla di rivoltella. Arch. ital. chir., 1938, 48: 665 78.-- Aysman, I. M. [Case of suture of t he heart] Vest, khir., 1938. :>6: 797. Ualedent, M., & Bizard. (;. Resultat functionnel eioignS d'une suture du cceur. C. rend. Soc. biol.. 1930, 103: 730 2- Baltscheflsky. H. [Suture of heart wound) Fin. liik. sail, hand., 1931, 73: 814-6.- Beck, C. S. Wounds of the heart; the technique of suture. Arch. Surg., 1920, 13: 205- 27. Berzsenvi. Z. [Late results of cardiac suture] Budapesti orv. ujs., 1937, 35: 329-31.—Bigger, I. A. Wounds of the heart and pericardium; a report of eases and a summary of the literature of sutured heart wounds. South. M.J., 1932, 25: 785 93.—Blagoveshchensky. M. A. [Case of heart suturing and its results 2K' years after the operation] Vest, khir., 1937, 51: 79.—Bufalini. G. Llteriore contributo clinico alia sutura del cuore. Policlinico, 1926, 33: sez. prat., 653-6.—Bulynin, I. I. |Histological structure of the cicatrix of the cardiac muscle following application of suture] Vest, khir., 1939, 58: 369-71.—Butler d'Ormond, R. de. J.a suture du cceur. Clinique, Par., 1928, 23: 127.—Cole, W. H. Suture of wounds of the heart; with report of a recent case. Ann. Surg., 1927, 85: 647-52.—Costa, T. Considerazioni cliniche sopra una eardiorrafia. Rass. internaz. clin. ter., 1931, 12: 1136-9.— Cutler, E. C, & Beck. C. S. The technique of cardiorrhaphy. Surg. Gyn. Obst., 1927, 45: 74-9.—Doughty, R. G. Two cases of suture of stab wounds of the heart. Ann. Surg., 1929, 89: 923-9.—Drummond, H. A case of heart suture. Newcastle M. J., 1924-25, 5: 42-4.—Duschl, J. Beitrag zur Chirurgie der Herzverletzungen mit Herznaht. Miinch. med. Wschr , 1926, 73: 1799.—Elkin, D. C. Suturing wounds of the heart. Ann. Surg., 1932, 95: 573-7.—Fedorov, D. N. [The question of heart suture] Kazan, med. J., 1940, 36: 70-4.—Fischer, G. Demonstration einer geheilten Herznaht nach StichverleUung. Arch. klin. Chir., 1939, 196: 609-11 [Discussion] 92-4— Genkin, I. I. Zur Technik des Verschlusses von Herzwunden. Ibid., 1934, 181: 324-9—Gobel I. R. Ueber die Dauerresultate nach Herznaht bei Schuss- und Stichverletzungen. Med. Welt, 1932, 6: 451-3.—Graves, J. Q. Cardiorrhaphy; with report of case of ventricular puncture. N. Orleans M. & S. J., 1928- 29, 81: 914-8.—Gusievas, V. [Two cases of heart sutures in punctured wounds] Medicina, Kaunas, 1929, 10: 493-8.— Horsch, K. Herzfunktion nach friiherer Herznaht. Beitr. klin. Chir., 1934, 160: 132-7.—Jakob. M. Mittels Naht geheilte Herzverletzung. Deut, Zschr. Chir., 1927, 201: 115.— Jiano, J. Deux cas de suture du cceur. P. verb. Congr. fr. chir., 1932, 41: 851-4.— Kramarenko. E. I. [Case of injury of the heart, suturing of the wound and reinfusion of blood] Vrach. delo, 1934, 17: 679-82.—Lastochkin, V. I. [Remote sequels of heart suture] Vest, khir., 1932, 27: 96-8.— Lenor- mant, ('. Plaie du coeur; suture; guerison. Bull. Soc. nat. ehii Par., 1926. 52: 513.—Levi. J. L. [Suture of the heart in per- forating knit"-- wound] Vrach. delo, 1935, 18: 563. -Mambrini, I). Contniito alia chirurgia del cuom: eardiorrafia in un ragazzo di ..ip. tnni. Aich. Soc. ital. chir. 0925) 1926, 32: 562 70. Mamikonov, M. I. Cardiorrhaphy in wounds of I be beau. Aim. Suig.. 1933, 97: 547-52. ------- [Car- diorrhaphy based upon 3 cases of fresh injuries to the heart] Vest, khir 1933, 30: 320-6.—Meleshchenko. S. V. [Case of placing Miiuie- of the tight auricle] Kazan, med. J., 1910. 36: 75. Meyrr-Ma>, J., : 7-12.- Nikolaev, I. A. ISuture of wounds of the heaitl Khirurgia, Moskva, 1939, No. 2-3, 152-4.—O'Day. J. C- 1V< icardial decompiesMon in the treatment of wounds of the heait after cardim rhapln. Ann. Surg.. 1927. 85: 653-8.—Palaz/.i. G.. & Ruggeri-. M. In caso di sutura del cuore. Policlinico, 1934, 41: sez. prat., 162. Rchn, E. Ilei z\a i Ictzung, Herznaht und Herzfunktion. Med, Welt. 1932, 6: 119 51. Rufanov, I. G. Spatresultatc einer Herznaht ( Nachunlcrsiicliiiiig nach 28 Jahren) Zbl. Chir., 1931, 58: 3138-10.- Sapozhnikov. E. I. |( 'ase of heart suture] Vrach. delo, 1908, 20: 685. Schoenfeld, H. H. Heart injuiies, with suture. Ann. Surg., 1938, 87: 823 8. Sccgcr, P. B. Ueber einen Fall von erfolgreicher Herznaht nach I lei zschiis-. und -tamponade. Chirurg, 1941, 13: 284-6.—Sherard, V. H , Stephens, S. H., & Hutchens, J. T. Cardiorrhaphy. South M. J., 1928, 21: 452.—Spigel, W. Successful cardiort liaphy . J. Am. M. Ass., 1933, 100: 115.—Sudhoff, W. Leber zwei Falle von Herznaht. Munch, med. Wschr., 1928, 75: 479. Sultan. Spatfolgen nach Herznaht. Med. Klin., Berl., 1927. 23: 109.—Teplitz, V. L. [Distant results of hear! suture] Vrach. gaz., 1926, 30: 994-8.—Vakhrameev, P. I. [Primal \ suture of the heart] Nov. khir. arkh., 1938, 41: 116 21. Vaulin, G. V. [Two cases of heart suture] Ibid., 19-10. 46: 264-6.—Znamensky, M. S. [Case of suture of a cardiac wound] Kazan, med. J., 1940, 36: 76. ---- Systole. Sec under Heart function. ---- Thrombus. See Heart chambers, Thrombus. ---- Tissue culture. See Heart muscle, Explantation. ---- Transplantation. Copenhaver, W. M. Results of heteroplast ie transplanta- tion of anterior and posterior parts of the heart rudiment in amblvstoma embryos. J. Exp. Zool., 1930, 55: 293-318. Mann, F. C, Priestley. J. T. [et al.] Transplantation of the intact mammalian heart. Arch. Surg., 1933, 26: 219-21. - Paff, G. H. Transplantation of sino-atrium to cohuh in the embryonic heart in vitro. Am. J. Physiol., 1936, 117: 313 7 — Sinitsyn, N. P. [Method of grafting an accessoi \ heart into the frog] Biull. eksp. biol. med., 1941, 11: 255. Stohr, P., jr. Zur embrvonalen Herztransplantation. Arch. Kntwmcch., 1929, 116: T. 1, 300-26.—Weiss, P. Herztransplantation an erwachsenen Amphibien. Arch. ges. Physiol., 1927, 217: 299-307. ---- Tumor. Sec Heart tumor. ---- Valve. Sec Heart valve. ---- Ventricle. See Heart ventricle. ---- Volume. See Heart, Size; Heart chambers, Capacity. For stroke and minute volumes see Blood circula- tion, Cardiac output; also Heart function. ---- Weight. See also Heart, Measurement; Heart, Size; Heart hypertrophy. Gewert, M. Ueber die Schwankungen des Herzgewichts in der verschiedenen Lebensaltern unter normalen und pathologischen Verhaltnissen. 50p. 8? Jena, 1929. Bong, E., Junkersdorf, P., & Steinhorn, H. Lntersuchungen iiber das relative Gewicht und die chemische Zusammensetzung des Herzens unter physiologischen und pathologischen Bedin- gungen: ein Beitrag zui Physiologie und Pathologie des Herz- stoffwechsels; Versuche an Hunden mit verschiedener Ernah- rung und im Hungerzustand. Zschr. ges. exp. Med., 1933-34, 92: 265-92—Busch. M. Die Schwankungen des Herzge- wichtes beim mannlichen Gesehlechl. Arb. Keichsgcsundhamt., 1926, 57: 690-702.—Cohn, A. E.. & Steele, J. M. ( hanges with age in cardiac and bodv weights of uiie-haiied fox tcrnei-. Am. J. Anat., 1936, 58: 103-7.- Daniels, A. L., & Burriuht, I. Heart weights of normal and anemic animals. Proc. Soc. Exp. Biol., N. V., 1933, 30: 857. Kulstow, M. Observations on the weight of the heart in schizophrenia and other mental disorders. HEART 221 HEART ARRHYTHMIA Proc. Ass. Res. Nerv. Ment. Dis., N. Y. (1925) 1928, 5: 310- 20.—Herrmann, G., Decherd, G. [et al.] Normal heart weight/ body weight (HW/BW) and left to right ventricular (L/Rl ratios for rabbits. Proc. Soc. Exp. Biol.. N. Y., 1935-36. 33: 409.—Kisch, B. Ueber das Herzgewicht einiger Selachier. Zschr. Kreislaufforsch., 1928, 20: 169-74.------Weitere Untersuchungen iiber das Herzgewicht der Fische. Ibid., 1929, 21: 385-9.—Levine, V., & Carr, J. G. Cardiac weights. Arch. Int. M., 1933, 52: 429-46. Also repr.—Munck, W. [Weight of the heart in various age periods and weight classes] Hospitals- tidende, 1936, 79: 311-9.—Palmgren, A. Herzgewicht und VVeite der Ostia atrioventricularia des Rindes. Anat. Anz., 1928, 65: 333-42— Reisinger, J. A., & Wilcox, B. B. Heart weight and the measurement of the cardiac silhouette. Med. Bull. Veterans Admin., 1938-39,- 15: 108-17.—Rosahn, P. D. Weight of the normal heart in adult males. Am. J. Path., 1941, 17: 595-7. Also Vale J. Biol., 1941-42, 14: 209-23.—Smith, H. L. The relation of the weight of the heart to the weight of the bods and the weight of the heart to age. Am. Heart J., 1928-29, 4: 79 93— Van Liere, E. J., & Sleeth, C. K. Normal heart-weight, bodv-weight (HW/BW) ratio in the guinea pig. Proc. Soc. Exp. Biol., N. Y., 1936, 34: 41. HEARTACHE. Sec Angina pectoris; Heart nerves, sensory; Heart neurosis; also names of primary diseases as Aortic valve, Disease; Endocarditis, etc. HEART arrhythmia. See also Heartbeat; Heart conduction; Hear! disease, functional; Heart muscle (subheadings); Heart neurosis; Heart rate; also names of heart diseases. Battro, A. Las arritmias en clinica. 476p. 23cm. B. Air., 1937. Herrmann, G. Disturbances of the heart- beat. p.718-801. 8? Phila., 1940. In Diagn. Treat. Cardiovasc. Dis. (Stroud, W. D.) Phila., 1940, 1: 718-801. Also In Cyclop. Med. (Piersol-Bortz) Phila., 1939, 3: 843-76. Licci, P. Le aritmie; pathologia e clinica. 299p. 8? Oenova, 1916. Lutembacher, R. Etude elementaire des arythmies; lecture des electrogrammes, phono-, et cinematographie. llOp. 4? Par., 1929. Perrin, M., & Richard, G. Les arythmies dans la pratique journaliere. 2. ed. l.">0p. 12? Par., 1932. Roth, I. R. Cardiac arrhythmias; clinical features and mechanism of the irregular heart. 210p. 8? N. Y., 1928. Schill, I. [Heart arrhythmias] 34p. 8? Budap., 1932. Tecce, S. Le aritmie cardiache. 318p. 8? Nap., 1934. Vaquez, H., & Doxzelot, E. Les troubles du rythme cardiaque. 288p. 4° Par., 1926. Weber, K. Arythmie; pathologic klinika poruch rytmu srdecnfho. 423p. 8? Praha, 1926. Wenckebach, K. F., & Winterberg, H. Die unregelmassige Herztatigkeit. 2v. 635p. 4? Lpz., 1927. Widmer, A. *Les arythmies observees au cours de l'annee 1931 a la Clinique medicale dc Geneve; etude pratique. 35p. 8? Geneve, 1933. Abramson, A. A. [Cardiac arrhythmia in practice] Vrach. gaz., 1931, 35: 219-24.—Annis, J. W. Cardiac arrhythmias. J. Florida M. Ass., 1941-42, 28: 71-8.—Berg, L. M. van den. Eine neue Form periodisch-inaqualer Herztatigkeit. Zschr. Kreislaufforsch., 1938, 31: 119-23.—Biondo, S. I disturbi del ritmo cardiaco. Cult. med. mod., Pal., 1927, 6: 275-9.— Bohan, P. T. Cardiac irregularities. Minnesota M., 1934, 17: 624-9.—Borman, M. C. Cardiac arrhythmias. West Vir- ginia M. J., 1929, 25: 385-9.—Brugsch, T. Arhythmien des Herzens. Erg. ges. Med., 1928, 11: 1-50, 5 pl.—Carr, J. G. Cardiac irregularities; their cause, recognition, and treatment. Illinois M. J., 1929, 56: 433-9.—Ceconi, A. Disturbi del ritmo cardiaco. Minerva med., Tor., 1927, 7: 786-95.— Chapin, L. D. The heart and its irregularities [Discussion] Abstr. Proc. Ass. Life Insur. M. Dir. America, 1915-16, 511- 28.—Chini, V. Alcune considerazioni sopra un raro caso di alterazione del ritmo cardiaco. Cuore & circol., 1926, 10: 243-9.—Cook, R. C. Cardiac arrhythmias. U. S. Veterans Bur. M. Bull., 1929, 5: 859-68.-Doege, K. H. Cardiac 1ArreP1lnt-es' Wisconsin M. J., 1932, 31: 453-8.—Engelen. Arrhythmia cordis. Zschr. arztl. Fortbild., 1929, 26: 788-90 — Evans, W. Cardiac irregularities other than auricular fibrilla- tion Med J Australia, 1938, 2: 1023-30.—Funkhouser. E. Lardiac arrhythmias. Indianapolis M. J., 1930 33: 15-8 — T'lo6'.?' Reflejismos cardfacos (ideas clinicas) Siglo med 1928 82: 277-9.-HaIl, D. Disturbances of the cardiac rhythm. Med. Press & Circ, Lond., 1936, 192: 28-31 — Harper, H. T., jr. The cardiac arrhythmias. Bull. Lniv Hosp. Georgia, 1939, 1: No. 2, 4-8— Henkel, G. Anfallsweise Storungen der Reizbildung und Reizleitung im menschlichen Herzen. Deut. Arch. klin. Med., 1930, 167: 244-55.—Hoskin T. J. Cardiac arrhythmias. Med. Press & Circ-., Lond. 1936' 192: 387 -94.—Hume, W. E. Arrhythmia. In Brit. Encvcl M. Pract. (Rolleston, H.) Lond., 1936, 2: 10-38.-Hutcheson, J. M Cardiac irregularities. Virginia M. Month., 1930-31 57: 717-20.- Klieneberger, C. Der unregelmassige Herzschlag' die Arh.\ thmie. Prakt. Arzt, 1933, n. F. 18:487 93 Kiilbs, F.. & Uhlenbruck, P. Acerca de las formas, diagn6stn o y pronostico de las arritmias. Rev. med. germ iber. amer., 1931, 4: 321-36.— Laliberte, H. Les arythmies en pratique journaliere. Bull. m6d. Quebec, 1931, 32: 161-9.— Levine, S. A. Cardiac irregularities. In Modern Med. Ther. (Barr, D. P.) Bait., 1940, 3: 2054-77.—Lian, C. Considera- ciones generales sobre el ritmo cardiaco y sus trastornos. Dfa med., B. Air., 1931-32, 4: 661; 669.—Lloyd, T. P., & Browning, W. H. The irregularities of the heart beat, Tri- state M. J., 1928, 1: 41-7.—Lopez Elizagaray. J. Relaciones entre las arritmias y la insuficiencia cardiaca aguda. Progr. clin., Madr., 1920, 15: 306-16.—Lutembacher, R. Les aryth- mies. Presse med., 1933, 41: 593.—Micheleau, P. E. Aryth- mies. Gaz. hop., 1933, 106: 327; 367.—Moxness, B. A. Car- diac arrhythmias in out-patients. Med. Bull. Veterans Admin., 1937-38, 14: 23-8. Also Mil. Surgeon, 1939, 84: 362-7 — Murphy, E. Cardiac arrhythmias. Med. J. Australia, 1932, 1: 283-92.—Nesbit, W. E. Uncommon cardiac arrhythmias. Texas J. M., 1925-26, 21: 710-14.—Polese, N. Sui disturbi del ritmo cardiaco. Morgagni, 1930, 72: 597-606.- Post, W. E. Cardiac arrhythmias. Internat. J. M. & S., 1931, 44: 21-3.—Prendergast, D. J. Cardiac irregularities. Bull. Acad. M. Toronto, 1934, 8: 16-9. Prudente, F. Sulla in- termittenza dei battiti del cuore. Filiatre sebezio, Nap. 1841, 22: 94.—Salley, S. M. Disturbances of cardiac rhythm. J. Florida M. Ass., 1908-39, 25: 087-93.—Smith, H. L. Car- diac arrhythmias and tachycardias. Mil. Surgeon, 1939, 84: 591-4.—Sonne, C. [Irregular heart action] Ugeskr. laeger, 1930, 92: 563-72.—Spaulding, E. Cardiac irregularities. Rep. Wayne Co. M. Soc, 1930-31, 36-9.—Staemmler, M., & Wohlenberg, W. Reizbildungs- und Reizleitungsstorungen im Herzen. Zschr. klin. Med., 1927, 106: 425-38.—Streng, K. O. Ein Fall von periodischer Rhythmusstorung des Her- zens. Acta med. scand., 1937, 91: 34-40.—Stuart, D. B. Arrhythmias. Virginia M. Month., 1934-35, 61: 631-4 — Turkeltaub, M. S. [Rare case of arrythmia] Sovet. vrach. gaz., 1933, 37: 702-4.—Vesa, A. [Case of arrythmia] Duo- decim, Helsin., 1938, 54: 299-304.—Wenckebach, K. F. Ueber die Arhythmien des Herzens. Mitt. Verein. Aerzte Steiermark, 1926, 63: 73-6.—Williamson, B. The arrhythmias in general practice. Practitioner, Lond., 1929, 123: 420-9.— Willius, F. A. Disturbances of cardiac rhythm. In his Card. Clinics, S. Louis, 1941, 174-97.—Wolffe, J. B. Two methods for teaching cardiac arrhythmias, correlating the electrical and hydrostatic events. M. & S. Yearb. Phvsicians Hosp. Pittsburgh, 1929, 1: 125.—Wood, E. E. Irregular heart- beat. J. M. Ass. S. Africa, 1931, 5: 212-5.—Zachariae. Die Rhythmusstorungen des Herzens. Fortsch. Med., 1939, 57: 102-7. ---- absolute. See Heart auricle, Fibrillation; Heart sound, Gallop rhythm. ---- Allorhythmia. See subheading Parasystole. ---- Alternation. See under Heart muscle. — auricular. See under Heart-block. Auriculo-ventricular rhythm. See also Heart arrhythmia, chronotropic; Heartbeat, Automatism; Heart rate, Brady- cardia; Heart neurosis; also names of cardiac poisons, and infectious diseases. Belski, A. Beobachtungen iiber atrioventrikulare Auto- mate im Verlauf der Infektionskrankheiten. Zschr. klin. Med., 1908-9, 66: 515-23, pl.—Chamberlain, E. N. Atrio- ventricular rhythms. Lancet, Lond., 1927, 2: 1383-6.— Daniclopolu. D., & Proca, G. G. Recherches sur le rythme atrio-venti iciilaite chez I'homme; deductions g6n6rales. Arch. mal. cceur, 1926, 19: 247-58. ------ Action du vague, de la HEART ARRHYTHMIA 222 HEART ARRHYTHMIA compression oculaire, de la digitale, de l'adrlnaline, de 1'efTort, de la respiration et de la deglutition sur la bradycardie atrio- ventriculaire. Ibid., 225-31, 5 ch.—Dressier, W„ & Rosier, H. Wnenpulssymptome und Rontgenbefunde beim Atrioventri- kulairhythmus. Wien. klin. Wschr., 1929, 42: 701-4.— Montoro. O. Hitnio ati io-ventricular. Vida nueva, Habana, 1928, 22: 1-15.—Pezzi, C. Considerations pathog6niques sur quelques cas de rythme septal et para-septal permanents. Arch. mal. coeur, 1931, 24: 1-24.—Roos, J. [Atrio-ventricular heart rlnthin in the dog] Tschr. diergeneesk., 1937, 64: 969-85.- Scherf, I). Ueber den atrioventrikularen Rhythmus und die ati ioventrikuliire Leitung. Wien. klin. Wschr., 1931, 44:1157-60.----Ueber den atrioventi iculai en Rhythmus. Zschr. ges. exp. Med., 1931, 78: 511-26. Schott, A. Atrio- ventricular rhvthm with and without retrograde block. Am. Heart J., 1937, 13: 61-71.— Stejfa, M. [Case of permanent atrioventricular rhythm] Cas. 16k. Cesk., 1936, 75: 133-40. — Auriculo-ventricular nodal type [septal] rhythm: Inferior Lutembacher, R. Rythme auriculaire inferieur. Presse med., 1934, 42: 2096.—Salvesen. H. A. Intranodal heart- rhythm, produced bv exercise. Acta med. scand., 1932 78: 180; 79: Suppl. 50, 121. ---- Auriculo-ventricular rhythm: Nodal type [Mackenzie] Bullrich, R. A. Ritmo nodal transitorio; interpretaci6n clinica y electrocardiograffa. Rev. med. lat. amer., B. Air., 1931-32, 17: 181-8. ------ & Besimsky, M. Gonsid6rations au sujet dun cas de rvthme nodal. Rev. sudamer. mid. chir.. Par., 1931, 2: 1-11.—Castex, M. R., Lopez Ramirez, R., & Gonzalez, H. Ritmo nodal a complejos ventriculares peri6dicamente atfpicos. Prensa mid. argent., B. Air., 1927, 14: 721-6. Also Rev. Soc. med. int., B. Air., 1927, 3: 661-72.— Duchosal, P. Ueber einen Fall von spontanem Knotenrhyth- mus. Med. Klin., Berl., 1933, 29: 390-2. ------ & Sciclou- noff, F. Un cas de rythme nodal intermittent au cours d'une searlatine, flutter surajoute, assourdissement du premier bruit. Arch. mal. coeur, 1934, 27: 409-16.—Flaxman, N. Atrioventricular nodal rhythm. Am. J. M. Sc, 1941, 201: 857- 62. —Geraudel, E. A propos d'un cas d'arythmie sinusale critique du rythme nodal. Arch. mal. coeur, 1929, 22: 513- 22.—Hall, D. Auriculo-ventricular nodal rhythm following administration of (tuinidine in auricular fibrillation. Brit. M. J., 1936, 2: 589. Hinrichs, A. Beitrag zur Differential- diagnose des A. V.-Knotenrh\ thmus. Zschr. Kreislaufforsch., 1936, 28: 205-7.—Jones, T. D., & White, P. D. Atrioventricu- lar nodal rhythm; report of 2 cases exhibiting bigeminy. Am. Heart J., 1926-27, 2: 266-74.—Julian, F. B. A case of nodal rhythm. Lancet, Lond., 1932, 1: 1359.—Katz, L. N., & Kaplan, L. G. Unusual forms of rhythms involving the A-V node. Am. Heart J., 1938, 16: 694-700.—Leader, S. D. Nodal rhythm in an infant 18 months of age. Am. J. Dis. Child., 1935, 50: 1083. Also J. Mount Sinai Hosp., N. York, 1936-37,3:278-81.—Parsons-Smith,B.T. Nodalrhythm. Proc. R. Soc. M., Lond., 1934, 27: 1021—Peters, J. T. Eine neue Erklarung fiir bestimmte P-Zacken-Lokalisationen im Elektro- kardiogramm bei Tawara-Rhythmus des Menschen. Deut. Arch. klin. Med., 1927, 156: 99-110. Also Geneesk. gids, 1927, 5: 101-12.—Schweizer, F., de Filippi, F., & Battro, A. Cardio- pathia congenita; ritmo nodal. Arch, argent, pediat., 1931, 2: 217-22.—Vischer, C. V., & Lane, L. L. Auriculoventricular nodal rhythm, with report of cases. Ann. Int. M., 1932, 5: 1010-6. ---- Auriculo-ventricular rhythm: Nodal type: Type 2. See Heart-block, Auriculo-ventricular dissocia- tion. ---- Auriculo-ventricular rhythm: Supranodal type [paraseptal] Borman. M. C, & Meek, W. J. Coronary sinus rhythm; rhythm subsequent to destruction by radon of the sino-auricular nodes in dogs. Arch. Int. M., 1931, 47: 957-67.—Condorelli, L. Sui cosl detti ritmi paraseptali o sopranodali. Minerva med Tor., 1934, 25: pt 2, 417-20—Danielopolu, D., & Proca, G. dl Recherches sur le rythme atrio-ventriculaire chez I'homme; bradycardie atrio-ventriculaire transformee transitoirement en flutter. Arch. mal. cceur, 1926, 19: 217-24, 4 ch Rythme atrio-ventriculaire avec un complexe ventriculaire situ£ entre deux complexes auriculaires. Ibid., 232-40, 7 ch. ------ Presence simultanee d'un rythme atrioventri'culaire et dun flutter auriculaire partiel. Ibid., 241-6, 4 ch.—Gerau- del, E. Un cas de rythme atrio-ventriculaire; hysterosystolie auriculaire permanente. Presse med., 1926, 34: 1393-5.__ Hirai. J. Ueber die nach der Abtrennung des Sinus auftre- tende \ orhofautomatie. Jap. J. M. Sc, 1939-40, 6: Proc Biophysics, 110.—Marcellus, M. B. Migratory pacemaker with report of a case including autopsy findings. Northwest M 1934, 33: 189-95.-Ne8lin. W. Ueber eirfen autonomen \ orhofrhythmus. Wien. Arch. inn. Med., 1935-36, 28: ----• bathmotropic. See also other subheadings; also Extrasystole; Heart muscle, Excitability; Heart rate, Par- oxysmal tachycardia. tiloch, C. Zur Klinik der heterotopen Reizbildung; auto- matische und extrasystolische Erscheinungsweise urspriing- licher Reize von gleicher Periodik. Wien. Arch. inn. Med., 1937, 30: 365-84.—Ferris. C. R. Kxt .asystoles and paroxys- mal tachycardia. J. Missouri M. Ass.. 1933, 30: 439-43.— Lohr, H. A. [Relation between slow heterotopy and paroxys- mal tachycardia] Ned. tschr. geneesk., 1937, 81: 2026 9. Paassen, P. van [Disturbances in excitability of Ihe A -V- bundle of the heart] Ibid., 1926, 70: pt 2, 1713-7.- Palmer, R. S.. A White, P. D. The clinical significance of aberrant ventricular response to auricular premature beats and to paroxysmal auricular tachycardia. Am. Heart J., 1928-29, 4: 153-00.—Ritter, H. Zur Frage der vorzeitigen und zugleich abnormen Erregungsausbreitung im Herzen. Zschr. Kreis- laufforsch., 1939, 31: 206-9.--Routier, D. Un nouveau can d'extrasystolie ventriculaire benigne k pam.w sines tachy- cardiques. Arch. mal. cceur, 1937, 30: 224- 7. -Scherf, D., & Siedek, H. Experimentelle Untersuchungen uber die Chiiiin- wirkung auf Extrasystolen und extrasystolische Tachykardien. Zschr. ges. exp. Med., 1935, 96: 311-20.—Segers, M. be battement auto-entretenu du cceur; extrasystolie et taehy- cardie paroxystique. Ann. physiol., Par., 1939, 15: 921-4. ---- Bradyarrhythmia. See Heart auricle, Fibrillation. — Bradycardia [sinusal] See under Heart rate. — Classification. Cardiac arrhythmias, classification and treatment. Roche Rev., Nutley, 1936-37, 1: 309-15.—Chagas, E. Systematiza- cao das irregularidades da actividade do coragao. Fol. med., Rio, 1930, 11: 258.—Cutts, F. B. The transitions between normal sinus rhythm, ventricular escape, A-V nodal rhythm, and A-V dissociation. Am. Heart J., 1937, 13: 451-69.— Herrmann, G. Classification of disturbances of the physio- logical mechanisms of the heart beat. In Cyclop. Med. (Piersol- Bortz) Phila., 1939, 3: 849-76.—Lutembacher, R. Etude elementaire des arythmies; classification. Bull, med., Par., 1929, 43: 1211.—Moser, W. A consideration of two types of arrhythmia. Med. Rec, N. Y., 1936, 144: 269.—Pruche, A. Classification pratique des arythmies. Bull. Soc. med. Paris, 1935, 296-8.—Rosenberg, D. H. Fusion beats; a report of a clinical instance and an experimental study in the dog. J. Lab. CUn. M., 1939-40, 25: 919-25. ---- chronotropic. See also subheadings (Auriculo-ventricular rhythm; Paradoxical pulse; Sinus arrhythmia) also Heartbeat, Automatism; and subheadings of Heart rate. Auger, D., & Fessard, A. Sur l'analyse et le mecanisme de production des pulsations complexes provenant d'un entre- noeud de charac6e. C. rend. Soc. biol., 1935, 118: 975-7.— Averianov, P. P., Vogelson, L. I., & Fedorov, N. A. [Effect of excision of the sino-auricular node on the rhythm of the heart] Med. biol. J., Leningr., 1928, 4: No. 6, 75-88.—Borman, M. C. Partial destruction of the sino-auricular node in dogs' heart by excision and ligation. Am. J. Physiol., 1926, 77: 419-27. & McMillan, T. A. Destruction of the sinoauricular node in dogs' hearts by radon; an histological and electro- cardiographic study. Am. Heart J., 1927-28, 3: 208-18.— Bremer, F., & Deloyers, L. Consequence d'un heterochronisme des oreillettes droite et gauche sur la transmission de l'onde d'excitation auriculaire. C. rend. Soc. biol., 1926, 95: 232-6.— Condorelli, L. Sull'evoluzione delle turbe del ritmo cardiaco consecutive a lesioni sinusali e parasinusali. Bol. Soc. ital. biol. sper., 1927, 2: 925. Also Minerva med., Tor., 1927, 7: 9J0-7.—Dressier, W. Verschiebungen des Reizursprunges im Herzen. Verh. Deut. Ges. Kreislaufforsch., 1928, 169-75 [Discussion] 186-8— Fredericq, L. La suppression du nceud de Keith-Flack. Arch, internat. physiol., Liege, 1926, 27: 203-14— Rylant, P. Ablation du nceud de Keith-Flack (sinus) chez le chien. C. rend. Soc. biol., 1925, 93: 820-8. ———- Ablation et greffe intra-cardiaque du nceud de Keith- Mack (sinus) chez la chSvre, le mouton, le chat et le lapin; greffes heterogenes du nceud de Keith-Flack chez le chien, la chevre et le mouton. Ibid., 1926, 95: 1439-41. —---- Contribution k l'etude des centres d'automatisme cardiaques; ablation et greffe intracardiaque du nceud de Keith-Flack, sinus, chez le chien. Arch, internat. physiol., Liege, 1926, 26: 113-46. ■------ Contribution & l'etude de l'automatisme et de la conduction dans le coeur; ablation et greffe intracardiaque du nceud de Keith-Flack, sinus, chez la chevre, le mouton, le chat et le lapin; greffes heterogenes du nceud de Keith-Flack chez le chien, la chevre et le mouton. Ibid., 1927, 28: 225-60. Also Bull. Acad. med. Belgique, 1927, 5. ser., 7: 161-200; 4 pl.—Wachstein, M. Untersuchungen am Purkinjefaden. HEART ARRHYTHMIA 223 HEART ARRHYTHMIA experimentelle Storungen der Reizbildung und Kontraktilitat. Zschr. ges. exp. Med., 1932, 83: 491-536.—Winternitz, M. Zur Klinik der Reizbildungsstorungen im Sinusknoten. Verh. Deut. Ges. Kreislaufforsch., 1928, 176-9 [Discussion] 186-8. ---- combined. Abrahamson, L. Atrioventricular nodal rhythm with bi- geminy. Irish J. M. Sc, 1930, 6. ser., 64, 2 pl. Also Med. Press & Circ, Lond., 1930, 129: 195—Berard, A. Troubles rythmiques complexes; crises de tachycardie supraventricu- laire; dissociation auriculo-ventriculaire anisorythmique; arythmie complete transitoire; retour au rythme sinusal. Arch. mal. cceur, 1939, 32: 032-7.—Bloch. C, & Fischer, F. Zur Klinik der heterotopen Reizbildung; Automatic mit wechselndem Austrittsblock und Uebergang in Bigeminie. Wien. Arch. inn. Med., 1937, 31: 33-58.—Boros, J. Suprano- daler Rhythmus mit atrioventrikularer und iiitraaurikulare< Leitungsstorung. Zschr. ges. exp. Med., 1929, 67: 191-205.— Hi Guglielmo, G. Una forma di aritmia complessa. Boll. Soc. med. chir., Pavia, 1926, n. ser., 1: 769-75. ------ Re- perti istologici in una forma di aritmia complessa. Ibid., 1928, n. ser., 3: 115-21.—Fulchiero, A. Sulla sindrome tri- aritmica di Wolf, Parkinson e White. Minerva med., Tor., 1935, 26: 310-8.—Fussell, M. H., & Wolferth. C. C. A case exhibiting slow auriculoventricular rhythm and paroxysmal tachycardia with unusual ability to interrupt the fast rate. Tr. Ass. Am. Physicians, 1920, 35: 189-203.—Gravier, L., Froment, R., & Guiran, J. B. Brady-arythmie sinusale avec automatisme ventriculaire permanent et reciprocal rhythm. Arch. mal. cceur, 1939, 32: 622-31. ---- Delirium cordis. See Heart auricle, Fibrillation. ---- Diagnosis. Bradford, C. W. *The instrumental recog- nition of cardiac irregularities [St. Joseph's Hospital] 33p. 4? St. Paul, 1927-28. Borg, J. F. The use of quinidin in diagnosis and treatment of obscure cardiac arrhythmias. Tr. Am. Ther. Soc, 1936, 36: 88-91.—Brednow, W., & Deppe, B. Kymographische und elektrokardiographische Untersuchungen bei Rhythmusstorun- gen des Herzens. Zschr. klin. Med., 1935, 128: 223-37 — Camp, P. D. CUnical diagnosis of irregularities of the heart. Virginia M. Month., 1937-38, 64: 123-7.—Danielopolu, D., Asian, A., & Proca, G. G. L'epreuve du reflexe carotidien dans les arythmies. Bull. Soc. med. hop. Bucarest, 1928, 10: 40-4.— DeLee, R. B. Diagnosis and treatment of the cardiac arrhyth- mias. Tristate M. J., 1937-38, 10: 1968; 1980.—Dillingham, W. R. Some practical points in the diagnosis of cardiac arrhythmias. Am. Physician, 1926, 31: 484.—Ernstene, A. C. Bedside recognition of the disturbances of cardiac rhythm. Cleveland Clin. Q., 1939, 6: 12-7.—Fukui, N. Epigastric pulsation; the diagnosis of the arrhythmia cordis through the epigastriogram. Arch. Int. M., 1926, 38: 360-6.—Gaeta, A. P. Valutazioni medico-legali sui disturbi del ritmo ed efiicienza cardiaca. Arch, antrop. crim., 1933, 53: 1443-6.— Jores, A. Acerca de la importancia practica del ritmo de las 24 horas en el hombre. Rev. med. germ. iber. amer., 1935, 8: 401-9.—Kapff, W. von. Diagnose und Therapie der unregel- massigen Herztatigkeit. Aerztl. Rdsch., 1936, 36: 107-13 — Kaufmann. Die Beurteilung der unregelmassigen Tatigkeit und der Frequenzstorung des Herzens am Krankenbett ohne instrumental Hilfsmittel. Vereinsbl. pfalz. Aerzte, 1930, 42: 373.—Koch, V. W. Bedside diagnosis of cardiac irregularities and their treatment. Wisconsin M. J., 1908, 37: 277-81.— Lian, C, & Blonde), A. Diagnostic clinique des troubles du rythme cardiaque justiciables du sulfate de quinidine. J. med. fr., 1928, 17: 211-5.—Lutembacher, R. La schematisation lumineuse dans l'6tude des arythmies. Bull, med., Par., 1928, 42: 1256.—Luten, D. The significance of abnormal cardiac rhythms. Med. Clin. N. America, 1936-37, 20: 537-46.— McGuire, J. The recognition, pathologic mechanism and treatment of cardiac irregularities. J. Med., Cincin., 1933, 14: 359-64.—Mixson, H. J. CUnical and electrocardiographic recognition of the cardiac irregularities. Med. Rec, Houston. 1930, 24: 648-50.—Mohler, H. K. The diagnosis and treat- ment of the more common cardiac arrhythmias. Med. CUn. N. America, 1936-37, 20: 17.5-89.—Ocaranza, F. Las arrit- mias; su valor clinico. Medicina, Mix., 1932, 12: 57-71.— Padilla, T. Significado e interpretation clinica de las arritmias. Dfa med., B. Air., 1931-32, 4: 675-7.—Perry, C. B. The clinical recognition of cardiac arrhythmias. Clin. J., Lond., 1931, 60: 163-6.—Reid. W. D. Schema for diagnosis of heart rhythm. Boston M. & S. J., 1927, 196: 225. •------ Guides to the clinical diagnosis of cardiac rhythms. N. England J. M., 1929, 200: 487-91.—Reifenstein, E. C. The diagnosis and treatment of cardiac arhythmias. Internat. Clin., 1926, 36. ser., 1: 7-24, 14 pl.—Roch. Les troubles du rhythme cardiaque; leur diagnostic au lit du malade et leur traitement. Rev. med. Suisse rom., 1932, 52: 740-61.—Rowland, D. The bedside diagnosis of cardiac arrhythmias. J. Arkansas M. Soc, 1941-42, 38: 102-4.—Scott, R. W. The diagnosis and management of cardiac arrhythmias. Proc. Interst. Postgrad. M. Ass. N. America, 1937, 368-71.—Shaw, M. E. La aplicaci6n del esfigmomanometro al diagn6stico de las arritmias. Rev. espan. med. cir., 1933, 16: 338.—Shook. H. H. Clinical recognition and importance of the cardiac arrythmias Kentucky M. J., 1930, 28: 393-7.—Silberberg, M. D. The clinical recognition of the arrhythmias and their treatment. Med. J. Australia, 1936, 1: 115-22.—Simpson, V. E. The interpretation and significance of cardiac arrhythmias. West Virginia M. J., 1928, 24: 1-14.—Smith, A. L. CUnical recog- nition of cardiac arrhythmias. Mississippi Valley M. J., 1940, 62: 152-4.—Spitzer, H. Die unregelmassige Herz- tatigkeit am Rontgenschirm. Fortsch. Rontgenstrahl., 1929, 39: 126-32.—Stern, N. S. Clinical recognition of the arrhyth- mias. South. M. J., 1929, 22: 4 8-52.—Stewart, W. C. The significance of the cardiac arrhythmias. West Virginia M. J., 1936, 32: 113-6.—Stumpf, P. Arhvthmien des Herzens im Rontgenbild. Verh. Deut. Ges. inn. Med., 1930, 42. Kongr., 325-32.—Talley, J. E. How to tell the cardiac arliythmias at the bedside. Med. Clin. N. America, 1927,. 10: 1421-9.— Vander Veer, J. B. The diagnosis and treatment of abnormal cardiac rales and rhythms. Ibid., 1937, 21: 1033-48.— Vladysik, M. M., & Sosina, B. M. [Disorders of the heart rhythm in roentgen kymographic presentation] Klin. med. Moskva, 1938, 16: 1345-54, 3 pl.—Wirth, W. R. The signif- icance of cardiac arrhythmias as encountered in general practice. N. Orleans M. & S. .1., 1936-37, 89: 491-500. ---- Dissociation. See under Heart-block. ---- dromotropic. See Heart-block; also Heart conduction, ---- Dropped beat. See under Heart-block. ---- Electrocardiography. Audibert, V., & Erlande-Brandenburg, G. Eiectrocardio- gramme d'interpretation difficile au cours d'une arythmie. Marseille med., 1938, 75: pt 2, 475-9.—Chvala, F., & Kova- fovic, J. [Electrocardiographic statistics on arrhythmia] Cas. lek. cesk., 1933, 72: 1117-9.—Clerc, A. Sur c'ertaines modifications cliniques presentees par le sens de l'onde 61ec- trique auriculaire. In Livres jubil. Roger, G. H., Par., 1932, 75-80.—Dubuisson, M. Etude de 1'eiectrocardiogramme dans la decoordination des pulsations. Arch, internat. physiol., Liege, 1934-35, 40: 181-8.—Hart, T. S. Cardiac arrhythmias; a comparison of the bed-side diagnosis with electrocardiography. Long Island M. J., 1929, 23: 22-6— Hrom, S. [Cardiac arrhythmia; clinical and electrocardiographic investigations] Polskie arch. med. wewn., 1938, 16: 341-96, 5 pl—Lian, C, & Viau. O. Diagnostic eiectrocardiographique des troubles du rythme cardiaque justiciables de la quinidine. J. med. fr., 1928, 17: 216-22.—McMillan, T. M. Electrocardiography and the cardiac arrhythmias. In Dis. Chest (Norris, G. W., & Landis, H. R. M.) 6. ed., Phila., 1938, 186-221.—Michelazzi, A. M. Sulle alterazioni complesse e transitorie del ritmo cardiaco; contributo elettrocardiografico. Riforma med., 1939, 55: 711-8.—Mosler, E. Der Wert des Elektrokardio- gramms fiir die Diagnose und Therapie der Arrhythmien. Ther. Gegenwart, 1932, 73: 99-105.—Mussafia, A., & Puddu, V. Confronto fra due derivazioni precordiali. Cuore & circol., 1939, 23: 281-90.—Nattkemper, R. L. The electrocardiogram in the diagnosis of the cardiac arrhvthmias. U. S. Nav. M. Bull., 1927,25:862-71. ---- Escaped beats. See Heart-block; Heart rate, Bradycardia. ---- Etiology. See also names of primary diseases as Heart rheumatism; Heart valve,Disease; Thyrotoxicosis, &c. Deb ax, P. *Les troubles du rythme cardiaque d'origine traumatique; etude medico-legale. 60p. 25^cm. Lyon, 1938. Albert-Weil, J. Les facteurs extracardiaques, anaphy- lactiques, hepatiques, hepatodigestifs et endocriniens des troubles du rythme et de la tonicite cardiaque; le choc arvth- mique. Presse med., 1938, 46: 1148-50. ------& Benech, A. Les facteurs extracardiaques, hepatiques, hepatodigestifs et anaphylactiques des tachycardies et des tachyarythmies; le choc arythmique. C. rend. Congr. internat. insuff. h6pat., 1937, 1. Congr., 532-6.—Antoniazzi, E. Disturbi del-ritmo cardiaco d'origine leucemica? (controUo istopatologico e possi- bility patogenetica) Clin. med. ital., 1931, 62: 53-66 — Bizzozero, R. C. Las arritmias como expresi6n de enfermedad miocardica. Dia med., B. Air., 1938, 10: 1069-71.—Blondel. Trastornos del ritmo cardfaco en las infecciones e intoxica- ciones. Ibid., 1931-32, 4: 355; 367.—Campbell, M. The St Cyres lecture on the aetiology of cardiac arrhythmias. Guy's Hosp. Rep., Lond., 1935, 85: 471-504.—Dumas, A. L'arythmie des hypertendus. J. med. Lyon, 1938, 19: 555- 61.■—Enescu, J., & Vacareann, N. Troubles du rythme pro- HEART ARRHYTHMIA 2: voqnis i ai ! atropine. Audi. mal. coeur, 193S, 31: 1223 36.— Ficssingcr. ('. l.es arythmies des vieillards. J. prat., Par., l'i.!S r>2: S.M.— Fried, E. [Ltiologv and therapy of cardiac inh.\ thniial Binlapcsti orv. ujs., 1931. 32: 697-709.— Gilia- revs'ky, S. A.. & Galenkov, X. G. [Unusual cardiac rhythm in transposition of the viscera] Tr. Moskov. gosud. med. inst., 1935. No. 3, 1S7-92. - Harkavy, J. Cardiac arrhythmias with -pecial reference to paroxysmal tachycardia, auricular fibrilla- tion and premature beats in constitutionally allergic indi- viduals. J. Mount Sinai Hosp. N. York, 1938-39, 5: 273 86.— Hertz, I . Ver.-agen der Reizperiodik am geschadigten Herzen. Arch. exp. Path., Berl., 1932. 166: 570-83.- Lucke, H. Leber /.entrai ausgeloM-e Herzrli\ t liuuis.-toi ungen. Deut. Arch. klin. Med., 1937. ISO: 10 7. Medvei. ('. V.. A Uiberall. H. Ueber sehwere, von der Mund- und I'liai ynxsclileiinliaiit auslosbarc Khytliinusstoiuiigeii des Herzens. Wien. klin. Wschr., 1938, 51: 23-1 7. Pitfield, R. L. Cardiac aiMtlnnia due to brain tumor. J. Nerv. Ment. Dis.. 1930, 71: 33-5. —Thienes. C. H., (ireeley, P. O., & Guedel, A. E. Cardiac arrhythmias under . \.-l,,,,,,,,,.,ne anesthesia. Anesthesiology, 194l", 2: 611-20.— Weil. J. A.. & Benech. A. I.e choc arythmiquc; importance de« facteurs exliacuidiaques dans la physiologie pathologique des troubles du rythme cardiaque. Avenir med., Par., 1938, 35: 54-64.—Zarday, I. PCxtrakardial bedingte Stc'irungen der lleizschlagfolge. Klin. Wschr., 1938, 17: 1213-5. ---- fetal. Sec also Heart rate, fetal; Heart sound, fetal. Antoine. T. Ein Fall von fotaler Herzailivllnnie. Zschr, Oeburtsh. Gyn.. 1926. 90: 112-5.—Barre tt Henriet. Un cas d'arythmie extra-systolique foetale. Bull. Soc. obst. gyn. Paris 1935, 24: 74.- Hyman, A. S. Irregularities of the fetal heart; phonocardiographic study of the fetal heart sounds from the fifth to eighth month of pregnancy. Am. J. Obst., 193(1, 20: 332-47. Lund, C. J. The recognition and treatment of fetal heart arrhythmias due to anoxia. Ibid., 1940, 40: 946 57. Marcel. M. P.. & Exchaquet, .1. P. L'eieetiocardio- giamme du foetus humain avec un cas de double rythme auriculaire v6nhe. Arch. mal. coeur, 1938. 31: 504-12.— Rihl, J., & Weinzierl. E. Beitrag zur Frage der fetalen Herz- arrhythmie. Arch. Gyn., Berl., 1927, 130: 626-45.—Scnwarz. Zur phjsiologischen Arrhythmie des fetalen Herzens. Ibid., 132: 479 [Discussion] 63-7.- Sontag, L. W., & Newbery, H. Incidence and nature of fetal arrhythmias. Am. J. Di-. Child.. 1941, 62: 991-9— Yanaihara. K. Ueber die echte Ai rh\ thiiue der fotalin Herztonc. Nippon fujinka gakkai zas.shi. 1933, 28: N'os. 8 1 1. 24. ---- Fibrillation. See under Heart auricle; Heart muscle; Heart ventricle. ---- Flutter. See Heart auricle, Flutter. ---- Gallavardin's syndrome. See Extrasystole. ---- Hemisystole. See under Heart-block. ---- inotropic. See under Heart muscle, Contractility, ---- juvenile. Comby, J. L'arythmie du cceur chez les enfants. Bull. Soc. med. hop. Paris, 1933, 3. ser., 49: 670-3.—Fischer, G. Comment trailer les troubles du rythme cardiaque chez les enfants. Concours med.. 1940, 62: 633.—Hecht, A. F. Die \rhythmie beim Kinde. Wien. klin. Wschr., 1928, 41: 232-4. Arhythrnie des Kindesalters. Wien. med. Wschr., 1928. 78: 291. Kryszek, H. [Arrhythmia in children] Warsz. ezas. lek . 1937, 14: 439-42.—Leffkowitz, M. Die Storungen der Schlagfolge de.- Herzens im Schulalter. Zbl. inn. Med., 1933, 54: 449; 465.—Lyon, R. A., & Rauh, L. W. The cardiac arrhythmias of childhood. J. Med., Cincin., 1939-40, 20: tis. Migliori, V. Ln raro caso di aritmia cardiaca in una l.iinba di sette anni. Riv. clin. pediat., 1938, 36: 694-707.— Morquio. L. La aritmia cardiaca en los ninos. Rev. med., Ko-aiio, 1927, 2: 45-66.—Nobecourt, P. Troubles du rythme uaidiaque chez les enfants. Gaz. hop., 1939, 112: 641-50.— t'aton. J. H. Cardiac arrhythmia in childhood. Edinburgh M. L, 1927, n. ser., 34: 1-18.—Peiper, A. Unregelmassige Herz- tatigkeit un Kindesalter. Deut. med. Wschr., 1930, 56: 1079- M -Schroeder. O. von. Echte Arhythrnie der kindlichen lb mono. Zbl. Gyn., 1929, 53: 1586-8. ---- Manifestation. See also Heart disease, Manifestation. Wuxsche [K. O. A.] H. W. *Anfallsweise uuftretender Rhythmenwechsel als Ursache un- 4 HEART ARRHYTHMIA klarer Hcrzbeschwerden [Leipzig! 23p. 2'il/>vm. Zeulenroda, 1937. Bazzicalupo, <;. Seiueioloein del ritmo cudiaco. Go/./ internaz. med. chir., 193.">. 43: 107-12.- Eckey, P., Giinzel. A., & Wiinschc. II. W. Anhillsueise auftretender Rhythmen- wechsel al- Lisai lie unklai ei 11 crzbeschu erden. Deut. med. Wsehr., I9.SN, 64: 1(19 12. Laubry. <'., & Trocme, P. Sur le diagnostic et la yaleui seiniologic|iie des syncopes dans le^ arythmie.-. Bull, med . Par., 1927. 41: 349 54. Slejfa. M. [Disorders of consciousness in cardiac diseases, especially in arrhythmia] Bratisl. lek. lisfy, 1935, 15:551 8. ---- Manifestation: Pulse. Maliwa, 10. Storungen in dvv Krequenz iiml Rhythmik lies Pulses. 70p. S? Wien, I1I2N. Andrade, G. de. Pulsos iiieongruens; eonceiio. palogenia, signifieacao diagnostic;!. S. Paulo med., 1941. 14:461 70. Bomstein, .1. P. [Irregularities of pulse in children and ado lescentsl IVdiatrin, Moskva, 1928, 12: 139-44.- Bouchard, ('. Sopra un caso di polso intermittente. Riforma med., 191 I, 27: 17.- Coen, J. Abnormalities of the heart beat; their recogni- tion and effect on the pulse. Med. J. Australia, 1929, 1: 126 30.—Elias, H. Dei unregelmassige Puis. Wien. klin. Wseln., 1934,47: 625. Coldscheider, A. Pulsresonator und Arhyth- rnie. Deut. ine.l. Wschr., 1927, 53: 1074. Also Klin. Wschr. 1927, 6: 1401. Also Med. Klin.. Berl., 1927, 23: 900-2, Also Munch, med. Wschr., 1927. 74: 914. Norr. Pulsus myurus beim Pferde. Berl. tierarztl. Wschr., 1923, 39: 270-2 — Rubino, A. Contributo sperimentale alio studio del polso nelle aritmie cardiache. Riv. pat. sper., 1934, 13: 33 44, ,'i diag.—Scott, R. T. Irregularities of the pulse. Northwest AI., 1930, 29: 316- 22.—Taquini, A. C. Les pouls ocsophagiens pathologiques. C. rend. Soc. biol., 1937, 126: 145.—Wolf, H. J., & Bonsdorff, B. von. Das absolute Sphygmogramm bei Rhythmusstorungen des Herzens (Extiasystolie, absolute Arrhythmie, partieller Herzblock) Zschr. ges. exp. Med., 1933, 87: 92-102. ---- Paradoxical pulse. See Pulse, paradoxical. ---- Parasystole[Allorhythmia]and pararhythm. Sec; also Extrasystole; Heart-block. Blumgart, H. L., & Gargill, S. L. The mechanism of transi- tions from auriculo-ventricular dissociation to S-A rhythm; its relation to theory of parasystole. Am. Heart J., 1929--30, 5: 437-47.-—Boer, S. de. Vergleichende Physiologic des Herzens von Evertebraten: behaufte Extrasystolie und Flimmern bei Maja verrucosa. Arch. sc. biol., Nap., 1928, 12: 510-35.— Buchem, F. S. I*, van. Parasystolic. Ned. tschr. geneesk., 1926, 70: pt 2, 1652-61—Calabresi, M. Contribute alia conoscenza delle pararitmie. Clin. med. ital., 1931, 62: 331- 410, 6 ch.—Doumer, E. Les parasystolies k rythme lent et le mecanisme des extrasystolies rythm6es. Arch. mal. coeur, 1938, 31: 491-503.—Estape, F. de A. Sobre el problema de la oarasistolia. Actas Congr. nac. med., B. Air. (1931) 1932, 4. Congr., pt2,32-44. ■----- Parasistolia perpetua. Ars medi- ca, Barcelona, 1935, 11:120-46.—Falchetti, G. Alloritmie— poliritmie e poliaiitmie nei vivente. Cult. med. mod., Pal. 1939, 18: 296-304.—Faltitschek, F., & Scherf, D. Klinischei Beitrag zur Parasystoliefrage. Wien. Arch. inn. Med., 1932, 23: 269-96.—Feher, S. Ein Fall von Parasystolic bei Flatter- arhythmie. Ibid., 1928, 15: 29-36, tab., eh.—Fischer. R. Klinische Studien zur paroxysmalen Tachvkardie und zm Parasystolic. Ibid., 16: 137-78. -- & Kiss, A. Ein Beitrag zur Kenntnis der Pararhvthmien. Deut. Arch. klin. Med., 1929, 164: 73-86.—Grover, V. Pararhythm; an explana- tion of its mechanism with a report of an illustrative case. Brooklyn Hosp. J., 1940, 2: 6-13.—Hanns, A. L'intersystole et le chevauchement pathologique des systoles. Strasbourg med., 1931, 91: 297—Helbichova, A. [Case of ventricular parasystole in a 5 year old child] Cas. 16k. cesk., 1934, 73: 43-6.—Jervell, A. Ein Fall von Vorhofparasystolie. Acta med. scand., 1932, 79: 239-74. Koumans, A. K. J. [Case of pararrhythmia recorded with the aid of the direct cardiograph of Duchosal and Luthi] Ned. tschr. geneesk., 1933, 77: 642 55, 2 pl.—Mattioli, M. La pararitmia. Morpagni, 1934, 76: 108; 143.— Rothberger, C. J., & Sachs, A. Interferenzeii und Parasystolic in Streifen aus dem linken Vorhof des Warm- bliiterherzens. Arch, internat. pharm. dvii. Par. 1939, 62: 417-26.—Routier, D., ct Puddu, V. Klinischer Beitrag zur Frage der Pararhythmien. Zschr. klin. Med., 1936-37, 131: 89-98.—Scherf, D. Zur Entstehungsweise der Extrasystolen und der extrasystolischen Allorhythmien. Zschr. ges. exp. Med., 1926, 51: 816-73.—Schott, A. Beitrag zur Frage der Parasystolic Ibid., 1927, 55: 762 -75— Shingo, A. Klinisch- experimentelle Lntersuchungen uber einen Fall von soge- nannten Parasystolic Nagoya J. M. Sc, 1929,4: 74-94, pl.— Sinnhuber, F. Die Uiiregelmiissigkeit des Pulsus und seine Beurteilung fur die Militai taimlichkeit. Deut. mil. arztl. Zschr., 1912, 41: 574-SS. Taquini, A. C. Pararritmia auri- cular con QRS ancho y mellado. Rev. argent, card., 1941-42, 8:59-63. HEART ARRHYTHMIA 225 HEART ARRHYTHMIA ____ Parasystole and pararhythm, bigeminal. Allen W F. An experimentally produced premature sys- tolic arrhythmia (pulsus bigeminus) ini rabbits; secondary fac- tors which do not produce it. Am. J. Physiol., 1930, 95: 190- 2qi __Calabresi, M. Ritmo automatico e bigeminismo a complessi elettrocardiografici ventricolari uguali. Cuore & circol 1932 16: 253-61, pl.—Capo, R. Bigeminismo cardiaco contiiiuo. Clin. med. ital., 1931, 62: 319-30 —-- . Sul bigeminismo extrasistolico regolare nei corso della msumcienza cardiaca. Ibid., 627-45.—Clerc, A.. L6vy, R., & Calo. A. Con- tribution k l'etude du rythme couple par bigemimsme sinusal; k propos de 5 cas personnels. Arch. mal. coeur, 1938, 31: 1175-94.—Coogan, T. J. Analysis of an unusual case of coupled ventricular beats. Med. CUn. N. America, 1934, 17: 1569-73.— Dressier, W. Ueber einen atrioventrikularen Doppelrhythmus. Deut. Arch. klin. Med., 1929, 164: 326-39.—Gonzalo, G. R. Pulso bigeminado y taquicardia accesional. Siglo med., 19^6, 78: 627.—Hacker, H. P. A case of pulsus bigeminus with regular absence of the auricular wave, due to overdosage with digitalis Lancet, Lond., 1915, 2: 543.—Hoesslin, H. von. Beobachtungen bei der Bigeminie des Herzens. Khn. Wschr., 1933, 12: 654-8.—Luten, D„ & Jensen, J. Ventricular bi- eemi'nv (parasystole or reciprocal rhythm) in atrioventricular rhythm. Am. Heart J., 1932, 7: 593-612— Mathieu, L. Un cas d'angor d'effort s'accompagnant de big6minisme. Rev. med. est, 1927, 55: 100-3.—Mohamed Ibrahim. A case of myocardial failure with pulsus bigeminus. J. Egypt. M. Ass., 1933, 16: 416.—Scherf, D., & Schott, A. Parasystolic durch einfa'che Interferenz mit Uebergang in Bigeminie. KUn. Wschr., 1930, 9: 2191-3.—Talon. Rythme bigemine perma- nent et'aptitude au service. Bull. Soc. m6d. mil. fr., 1937, 31: 91_6—Vanysek, R. [Importance of the bigeminal pulse] Cas.'iek. Cesk., 1908, 47: 969-71.—Vedoya, R-, & Rodriguez Battini, A. Un caso de pararritmia mostrando el mecanismo que conduce al bigeminismo extrasistdUco. Rev. argent. card., 1939-40, 6: 313-24. ---- Parasystole and pararhythm, quadrigemi- nal and trigeminal. Calo, A. Ritmi cardiaci a quattro tempi. Cuore & circol., 1937, 21: 422-31.—Laubry, C, & Routier, D. Bruit de galop et rythme k quatre temps. Prat. med. fr.. 1926, 5: (a) 1-6.— Mach, R. S., & Duchosal, P. Etude phonocardiographique d'un cas de rythme k quatre temps. BuU. Soc. med. hop. Paris, 1931, 3. ser., 47: 912-6.—O'Farrell, P. T. Observations on a case of pulsus trigeminus. Irish J. M. Sc, 1932, ser. 6, 11-6, pl.—Van Heerswynghels, J. Deux types de rythme k quatre temps; etude phonocardiographique. BruxeUes med., 1939-40, 20: 196. ---- Pathogenesis. Skramlik, E. v. Herzmuskel und Extrareize. 224p. 8? Jena, 1932. Bard, L. Du role des perturbations des reflexes intra- cardiaques dans le mecanisme pathogenique de rarythmie desordonnee. Arch. mal. coeur, 1926, 19: 769-90.—Bethe, A. Analogien zwischen Rhythmusstorungen des Herzens und Vorgangen in kunstlichen Kippschwingungssystemen. Klin. Wschr., 1941, 20: 33-6.—Boer, S. de. Die physiologische Grundlage und Klinik des unregelmassigen Herzschlages. Erg. inn. Med. Kinderh., 1926, 29: 391-518.—Capo, R. II ritmo cardiaco normale ed i suoi disturbi secondo alcune recentiteorie. Morgagni, 1930, 72: 1407; 1466.—Dikshit, B. B. The production of cardiac irregularities by excitation of the hypothalmic centres. J. Physiol., Lond., 1934, 81: 382-94.— Fredericq, H. Les bases experimentales des theories actuelles des arythmies cardiaques. Biol, med., Par., 1914-21, 12: 177; 221.—Hallion, L. Sur les bases physiologiques del in- terpretation des arythmies. Rev. prat. biol. appl., Par., 1929, 22: 161-9.—Hinrichs, M. A., & Warrick, G. Ultraviolet point radiation in the production of arrythmias in the heart of the chick embryo. Proc. Soc. Exp. Biol., N. Y., 1931, 28: 1057 — Hrom, S. L'arythmie cardiaque d apres les explora- tions cliniques et electrocardiographiques. Bull, internat. Acad, polon. sc, 1938, cl. med., 341-58, 4 pl.—Luisada, A. Le alterazioni del ritmo cardiaco e le nuove teorie vascolari. Riv. clin. med., 1926. 27: 871-80. ------ Moderations de la circulation peripherique au cours des troubles du rythme cardiaque. Arch. mal. cceur, 1927, 20: 65-84—Luten, D. Nervous influence on the occurrence of cardiac arrhythmias. South. M. J., 1929, 22: 576-80.— Melik-Giulnasanan, E. A. [Extracardiac nervous system and pathologic rhythms of the heart] J. eksp. biol., 1930, 14: 51-8.----— Extrakardiales Nervensystem und pathologische Herzrhythmen (.experi- mentelle Untersuchungen an Hunden) Zschr. ges. exp. Med. 1931 75: 212-22.—Meyer, P. Le dualisme du rythme car- diaque avec conservation de la liaison auriculo-ventriculaire; considerations generates, proposition d'un nouveau schema; etude des arythmies kla. lumiere des conceptions dualistes avec conservation de la liaison auriculo-ventriculaire. Arch. mal. coeur, 1939, 32: 225-9.—Murray, P. D. F. Uncoordinated contractions caused by egg white and by alterations in tne cation ratio of the medium in the heart of the chick embryo in vitro. Proc. R. Soc, Lond., 1934, ser. B, 115: 380-402 — Nahum, L. H. The role of the extrinsic nerves of the heart in the production of cardiac irregularities, "i ale J. Biol., 1934-35, 2274T6« *»L. 7. 4th series----15 7: 368.—Osterhout, W. J. V., & Hill, S. E. Pacemakers in Nitella; arrhythmia and block. J. Gen. Physiol., 1938-39, 22: 115-30.—Porak, R. Etude experimentale et schematique des arythmies. Presse med., 1929, 37: 1506.—Schott, A. Zur Frage der heterotopen Arrhythmien durch Carotidenab- klemmung. Arch. ges. Physiol., 1934, 234: 51-77.—Schott, E. Isolierte Muskelkrampfe im Rhythmus des Herzschlags im Gebiete der unteren Thorakal- und oberen Lumbalsegmente des Ruckenmarks. Zschr. ges. exp. Med., 1926, 50: 269-79.— Somer, E. de. Sur les variations des pressions minima et maxima des ventricules, les courbes respiratoires du coeur et leur rapport avec les arythmies. Bull. Acad, med., Par., 1936, 3. ser., 115: 146-56.—Veil, P. Des arythmies; etude critique des conceptions actuelles de la physiologie du rythme cardiaque; essai de synthase des troubles rythmiques fonctionnels. J. med. Lyon, 1931, 12: 43; 75—Wiggers, C. J. The physiologic basis for the clinical interpretation of cardiac irregularities. Northwest M., 1928, 27: 468.—Wolf, H. J. Dynamik des arrhythmischen Herzens. Verh. Deut. Ges. inn. Med., 1931, 43. Kongr., 94-6. ---- perpetual. See Heart auricle, Fibrillation. ---- Premature contraction. See Extrasystole; also Heart rate, Paroxysmal tachycardia. ---- Prognosis. Bay, E. B. Unusual prognosis in heart irregularities. Med. CUn. N. America, 1927, 11: 279-85.—Brauch, F. Zur Ver- ursachung und Bewertung des Vorkommens einer heterotopen Reizbildung am Herzen. Med. Klin., Berl., 1941, 37: 511-3.— Britvan, Y. M. [Diagnosis and prognosis of cardiac arrhythmia in relation to profession] Vrach. delo, 1929, 12: 1368.— Calandre, L., & Martin Rodriguez, F. Arritmia completa transitoria. An. Hosp. S. Jose, Madr., 1930-31, 2: 240-50 — Cassinis, U. Di alcuni disturbi del ritmo cardiaco e della loro importanza nella vita militare e sportiva. Arch, fisiol., Fir., 1933-34, 32: 525-44.—De Bernardinis, V. Le aritmie del cuore in rapporto alia idoneita. al servizio militare. Gior. med. mil., 1932, 80: 926-45, diagr.—Hoskin, T. J. Cardiac arrhyth- mias: their effect on the operative risk. Practitioner, Lond., 1932, 128: 437-46. ---- Reciprocal rhythm. See under Heart-block. ---- Sino-auricular block. See under Heart-block. ---- Sinus arrhythmia. See also Heart arrhythmia, chronotropic; also Heart function, Test. Bessone, F. Ricerche elettrocardiografiche sull'aritmia da sforzo. Minerva med., Tor., 1928, 8: pt 2, 95-112.— Boschetti, A. Contributo clinico alio studio deU'aritmia sinusale. Cuore & circol., 1939, 23: 191-9, pl.—Crespo Alvarez, A. Formas graves poco frecuentes de arritmia de seno. Arch, med., Madr., 1926, 23: 145-64.—Estape, F. de A. Arritmia sinusal y escaped beats. An. Hosp. S. Cruz, Barcel., 1930, 4: 258-^61.— Faulkner, J. M. The significance of sinus arrhythmia in old people. Am. J. M. Sc, 1930, 180: 42-7.—Fogelson, L. I. Ueber die Storungen des Sinusrhythmus. Zschr. Kreislauf- forsch., 1929, 21: 128-38.—Gallemaerte, V.,,& Van Dooren, F. L'arythmie d'effort (etude electro-cardiographique) Arch. mal cceur, 1927, 20: 377-400.—Herrmann, G. Sinus arrhyth- mia. In Cyclop. Med. (Piersol-Bortz) Phila., 1939, 3: 856.— Koff, S. Nonphasic sinus arrhythmia; report of 2 cases. Med Bull. Veterans Admin., 1940-41, 17: 307.—Mohammed Ibrahim. Sinus bradyarrhythmia. J. Egypt. M. Ass., 1933, 16: 373-5.—Porto, J. Troubles du rythme sinusal chez un malad avec cardiopathie congenitale et situs inversus total. Arch. mal. coeur, 1938, 31: 960-72.—Steele, J. M., & Anthony, A J Arrhythmia of the heart associated with Cheyne-Stokes breathing. Am. Heart J., 1932, 8: 357-69.—Thomayer, J. [Agonal arrhythmia] Cas. h§k. Cesk., 1909, 48: 89-94.— Vrzala, S. [Sinusal bradyarrythmia with states of uncon- sciousness in a boy 6 years of age] Ibid., 1941, 80: 644-6 — Winternitz, M. Zur Klinik der Reizbildungsstorungen im Sinusknoten. Zschr. Kreislaufforsch., 1928, 20: 381-4 — Wood, F. C. A case of sinus arrhythmia; with pulse slowing, accompanying each second normal respiration. Am. Heart J., 1929-30, 5: 104-12. ---- Sinus arrhythmia, respiratory. Buschmann, W. *Respiratorische Arhythrnie und Alter. 16p. 8! Bonn, 1938. Rademacher, H. *Auffassungen uber Ur- sachen, Vorkommen und Bedeutung der respira- torischen Arrhythmie. 28p. 22cm. Bonn, 1936. HEART ARRHYTHMIA 22G HEART ARRHYTHMIA Sander, 13. [M] *Respiratorische Arrhythmie bei geschiidigtem Herzmuskel. lip. 8? Berl., l'.Citi. Schulte-Krtjmpex, T. *Die respiratorische Arrhythmie bei Mvodegeneratio cordis. 16p. 20V/-cm. Bonn, 1937. Anrep, G. V., l'ascual, W., & Rossler, R. The reflex mech- anism of the respiratory arrhythmia. Proc. R. Soc, Lond., 1935-36, ser. B, 119: 191-217, 2 pl. ------ Respiratory variations of the heart rate; the central mechanism of the respiratory arrhythmia and the inter-relations between the central and the reflex mechanisms. Ibid., 218-30, 2 pl.— Franke-Stehmann, W. Untersuchungen iiber den Einfluss von Bewusstseinszustanden auf die respiratorische Arhythrnie. Arch. Psychiat., Berl., 1932-33, 98: 787-93.—Frick, W. Leber die relative Q-T-Dauer bei der respiratorischen Arrhyth- mie des Hundes. Zschr. Kreislaufforsch., 1939, 31: 349-55.— Hammouda, M. Leber die Ursache der respiratorischen Arrhythmie. Arch. ges. Physiol., 1936, 238: 107-12.—Hering, H. E. Ueber die Abhangigkeit der bei Lungenaufblasung und bei der respiratorischen Arrhythmie auftretenden Frequenz- anderungen des Herzens von den Blutdruckziiglern. Zschr. Kreislaufforsch., 1930, 22: 593-8.—Heymans, J. F., & Heymans, C. Sur le mecanisme de l'arythmie cardiaque respiratoire. C. rend. Soc. biol., 1927, 96: 716-8. Also Arch. sc. biol., Nap., 1928, 12: 153-62.—KUhne, K. Die respiratorische Arrhythmie bei Herzerkrankungen im Kindesalter. Mschr. Kinderh., 1936, 66: 7-15.—Norr, J. Ueber Atmungsarrhythmie bei Caniden. Verh. Deut. Ges. Kreislaufforsch., 1935, 8: 144-8 [Discussion] 160. ------ Starke atmungsbedingte Herz- arrhythmie beim wildlebenden (Rot-) Fuchs. Zschr. Biol., 1936, 97: 160-6.-—Pongs. Respiratorische Arhythrnie und Vaguspriifung. Deut. med. Wschr., 1914, 40: 1087.—Recht, G. Atmungsreflex und Atmungsbradykardie beim Karotissinus- druck. Wien. Arch. inn. Med., 1933, 24: 197-212.—Rijlant, P. L'arythmie cardiaque respiratoire. C. rend. Soc. biol., 1936, 123: 997-1001.—Schlomka, G. Leber die Abhangigkeit der respiratorischen (Ruhe-)Arrhythmie von der Schlagfrequenz und vom Lebensalter. Zschr. Kreislaufforsch., 1937, 29: 510-24. ------ & Dietrich, H. Leber das Verhalten der respiratorischen Arrhythmie beim Emphysemkranken. Ibid., 1938, 30: 453-61.- Schlomka, G., & Dressen, M. Ueber die respiratorischen Schwankungen der Q3-Zacke del Elektro- kardiogramms. Ibid., 1939, 31: 46-55.—Schlomka, G., & Hausen, J. Ueber das Verhalten der relativen Systolendauer in Abhangigkeit von der respiratorischen Arrhythmie. Ibid., 1937, 29: 834-46— Schlomka, G., : 117-9. Also Gior med. prat., 1926, 8: 136-10.— Fortunato, A. L'in- sufhcien/a auricolare sinistra (considerasuoia ed osservazioni cliniche) Rinasc. med., 1928, 5: 441-5.—Garcia Carrillo, E. linportaneia de los trastornos del ritmo cardiaco de origen auricular. Res. med., S. Jose. 1939-40, 4: 125-33.—Hukuda, K.. & Suzuki, T. Excessive prc^ure head as a cause of fatigue of atrium musculature of the heait of Japanese toads. Nagoya J. M. Sc, 1935, 9: 117-26.—Luisada, A. A review of advances of the study of auricular disorders. J. Lab. Clin. M., 1939-40, 2.">: 1146-56.—Pallaske, G. Totale Herzvorhofverknocherung mit Verkalkung beim Pferd. Deut. tierarztl. Wschr., 1928, 36: 523-7.—Pichon, E. Linsuffisance auriculaire gauche. Progr. med., Par., 1931, 1293-8.—Prusik, B. [Isolated insufficiency of the right auricle, diagnosis and treatment] Cas. lek. desk., 1936, 75: 1425-9, 2 pl —Schwab, R., & Aechter, A. Unter- suchungen mit unipolaren Thoraxableitungen bei Verdacht auf isolierte Hypertrophie des rechten Vorhofs. Deut. Arch. klin. Med., 1936-37, 179: 577-80.—Viebrock, A. Ein weiterer Fall von Herzvorhofverknocherung beim Pferd. Munch. tierarztl. Wschr., 1929, 80: 310-3. ---- Electrical potential. See also Electrocardiogram. Boer, S. de. Die Bowditch'sche Treppe bei den Vorhofen des Schildkrotenherzens. Zschr. vergl. Physiol., 1929, 9: 627-35.—Coelho de Oliveira, N. Modificac5es do complexo auricular. Vida med., Rio, 1940, 8: No. 3, 17-25.—Faber, F. Ist eine rhythmisch auftretende P-Welle iminer der Ausdruck einer Atrienkoiitraktion? Acta med. scand., 1932, 79: Suppl. 50, 115-20- Frcdcricq, H. L'eiectrocardiogramme poly- phasique des oreillettes de la tortue. Arch, internat. physiol., Liege, 1927, 29: 357-70. ------ Alteration de l'eiectrogramme auriculaire de la tortue, produites par une excitation isolee du nerf pneumogastrique. C. rend. Soc. biol., 1931, 108: 422-5.— Hahn, L., & Langendorf, R. Zur Morphologie des Vorhof- Elektrokardiogramms; Rechts- und Links-Hyperfunktions- typus des Vorhof-Elektrokardiogramms. Acta med. scand., 1939. 100: 279-95.—Huttmann, A. Ueber das Vorhofelektro- kanliogramm bei Cor bovinum. Zschr. Kreislaufforsch., 1938, 30: 171-4.—Matuoka, S. On the electrogram of the toad's heart-atrium under the action of KC1, acetyl-choline and vagus stimulation. Nagoya J. M. Sc, 1934, 8: 91-109. ------ On the effect of galvanic polarisation upon the electrogram of the toad's heart-atrium. Ibid., 111-6. ---- Examination. < ournand, A., & Ranges, H. A. Catheterization of the right auricle in man. Proc Soc. Exp. Biol., N. Y., 1941, 46: 462-6.—Deloyers, L. Procede pour l'investigation du travail des oreillettes droite et gauche du lapin immergees dans des bains separes tout en gardant leurs connexions. C. rend. Soc. biol., 1926, 95: 230.—Gronchi, V. La perfusione in situ del- I'atrio destro del cuore di coniglio. Arch. farm, sper., 1939, 67: 159-62.—Katsilabros, L. La percussion de l'oreillette gauche. Paris med., 1928. 69: 214.—Rautenberg, E. Die VorhofpuLsa- tion beim Menschen, ihre Registrierung und die bisherigen Resultate ihrer Erforschung. Samml. klin. Vortr., 1909, n. F., No: 557-8, Inn. Med., No. 171-2, 91-140. ------ VorhoiDuls und Venenpuls. Deut. med. Wschr., 1913, 39: 1033-5 [Dis- cussion] 1073.—Zarday, I. [New method for examination of atrial function] Orv. hetil., 1938, 82: 417-20. ---- Excitability. Buchthal, F. *Ueber das Refraktarstadium des Vorhofs [Berlin] p.349-57. 8? Munch., 1931. Also Zschr. Biol., 1931, 91: Ashman, R., & Garrey, W. E. Excitability of the turtle auricle during vagus stimulation. Am. J. Physiol., 1931, 98: 109-20.—De Waele, H., & Van de Velde, J. Un reflexe hvpertenseur des oreillettes. Ann. physiol., Par., 1939, 15: 945-7. Also C. rend. Soc. biol., 1939, 131: 1304. ------ Le reflexe hypertenseur des oreillettes est non seulement presso-sensible mais aussi chemosensible. Ibid., 1305. ------ La chemosensibilite du reflexe hypertenseur des oreillettes k divers toxiques. Ibid., 132: 310. ------ La reaction du reflexe hypertenseur des oreillettes k la respiration en air comprint et k l'exces d'oxygene. Ibid., 312. ------ Sensi- bilite des recepteurs du reflexe hypertenseur des oreillettes aux agents pharmacologiques. Ibid., 464.—Fredericq, H. Actions inotrope et tonotrope du courant continu sur 1 oreil- lette de la tortue. Ann. physiol., Par., 1936, 12: 737-40. Also Arch, internat. physiol., Liege, 1936, 43: 219-31.— Gronchi, V. _ Azione combinata della nicotina e della corrente indotta sull'atrio destro isolata di cuore di coniglio. Boll Soc. ital. biol. sper., 1938, 13: 1001-4.—Holz, S. Comporta^ mento alio stimolo faradico dell'atrio destro isolato di cuore di coniglio; azione combinata deU'adrenalina e della nicotina. Ibid., 1004-6.—Levi, M. Ricerche intorno all'eccitamento degli atri della Emus europaea. Arch, sc biol., Nap., 1926, 8: 56-68.—Segers, M. La reaction rythmee de l'oreillette gauche du lapin au courant constant. C. rend. Soc. biol 1939,131:132-5. ---- Fibrillation. See also subheading Flutter; also Heart muscle, Fibrillation. Emanuel, J. G. Auricular fibrillation. 31 p. 8? Birm., 1926. Also Birmingham M. Rev., 1926, n. ser., 1: 2; 71. Routier, D., & Thiroloix, P. L. L'arythmie complete. 45p. 8? Par., 1934. Bain, C. W. C. Auricular fibrillation and auricular flutter. CUn. J., Lond., 1926, 55: 485-92.—Barksdale. G. H. Certain aspects of auricular fibrillation. West Virginia M. J., 1936, 32: 544-8.—Blumenfeldt, E. Die absolute Herzunregelmassigkcit (Arrhythmia absoluta) ihre Erkennung und Behandlung. Med. Welt, 1934, 8: 299; 370.—Brill, I. C. Auricular fibrilla- tion; the present status with a review of the literature. Ann. Int. M., 1936-37, 10: 1487-502.—Calandre, L. Fibrilaci6n auricular; arritmia completa. Progr. clin., Madr., 1919, 14: 5-15.—Carlton, A. J. Auricular fibrillation. J. Michigan M. Soc, 1928, 27: 643-5.—Carr, E. C. Auricular fibrillation. U. S. Nav. M. Bull., 1941, 39: 217-22.—Ceconi, A. Disturbi del ritmo cardiaco; aritmia totale. Minerva med., Tor., 1927, 7: 742-9.—Choate, A. B. Auricular fibrillation. South. M. & S., 1936, 98: 649.—Couto, M. Arythmia completa. In his Clin. med., Rio, 1935, 2: 85-7.—Cowen, S. O. Auricular fibrillation. Med. J. Australia, 1927, 2: 69.—Dale, G. C. Auricular fibrillation. South. M. & S., 1940, 102: 702-4.—Davidson. S. W. Three cases of auricular fibrillation. Newcastle M. J., 1924-25, 5: 1-3.—Folsom, S. A. Auricular fibrillation. J. Florida M. Ass., 1930-31, 17: 11-8.—Frick. D. J., & Kennicott, R. H. Auricular fibriUation; a review of a series of cases. California West. M., 1928, 28: 779-84.—Hargrove, M. D. Auricular fibriUation. N. Orleans M. & S. J., 1936-37, 89: 57-61.—Herrmann, G. Auricular fibrillation. In Cyclop. Med. (Piersol-Bortz) Phila., 1939, 3: 869-71.—Krupski, A. Ueber Vorhofsflimmern, Arhythmia perpetua, sive completa beim Pferd. Schweiz. Arch. Tierh., 1931, 73: 51-5.—Lian, C. Du diagnostic, du pronostic et du traitement de l'arythmie complete. Hopital, 1926, 14: 106-10.—Liihr, K. Zur Arrhyth- mia absoluta. Zschr. klin. Med., 1934, 127: 392-5.—Luten, D. Auricular fibriUation. Week BuU. S. Louis M. Soc, 1934, 28: 429.—McEachern, D., & Baker, B. M., jr. Auricular fibriUa- tion; its etiology, age incidence and production by digitaUs therapy. Am. J. M. Sc, 1931, 183: 35-48.—Mackenzie, J. Auricular fibrillation. In Cardiac Classics (WilUus, F. A.) S. Louis, 1941, 769-93.—Maher, C. C. Auricular fibrillation. Illinois M. J., 1934, 65: 140-4. Also J. Kansas M. Soc, 1935, 36: 272-5.—Mevel, Y. De quelques cas d'arythmie complete. Gaz. med. France, 1936, 43: 163-5.—Michelazzi, A. M., & Luciani, A. RiUevi clinici, elettrocardiografici e terapeutici sopra 181 casi di fibrillazione atriale. Rass. fisiopat., 1939, 11: 265-82.—Mine, S. [Perpetual arrhytmia] Polska gaz. lek., 1934, 13: 473-5.—Mintz, S. De l'arythmie complete. Presse m6d., 1935, 43: 2033-5.—Mohler, H. K., & Lintgen, C. Auric- ular fibrillations; an analysis of 220 cases. Pennsylvania M. J., 1931, 35: 68-74.—Neilson, W. P. Auricular fibrillation. J. Oklahoma M. Ass., 1930, 23: 52-4.—Parade, G. W. Arrhyth- mia absoluta. Zbl. inn. Med., 1936, 57: 281-98.—Pruche, A. La fibriUation auriculaire. Paris med., 1937, 103: 389-95.— Rihl, J. Ueber das FUmmern der Vorhofe beim Irregularis perpetuus. Prag. med. Wschr., 1911, 36: 111-4.—Roos, J. Vorhofflimmern bei den Haustieren. Arch. wiss. prakt. Tierh., 1924, 51: 280-93.—Salgado, P. Sobre a fibrillacao do atrio. Brasil med., 1930, 44: 801-10.—Stameri, D. La arritmia completa; consideraciones clinicas y terapeuticas. Acci6n med., B. Air., 1940, 10: 369; 376.—Stein, D. Auricular fibriUa- tion. Med. World, 1932, 50: 159-63.—Stephens, G. A. Auric- ular fibrillation. Prescriber, Edinb., 1937, 31: 353.—Stroud. W. D., Laplace, L. B., & Reisinger, J. A. The etiology, prog- nosis and treatment of auricular fibrillation. Tr. Ass. Am. Physicians, 1931, 46: 52-65. Also Am. J. M. Sc, 1932, 183: 48-60.—Sweeney, J. A. The most common and persistent irregularity of the human heart; auricular fibriUation. Med. Clin. N. America. 1934. 18: 343-52. ---- Fibrillation: Associated disease. Condorelli, L. Fibrillazione auricolare transitoria durante a tachicardia nodale (ricerche elettrocardiografiche ed isto- patologiche) Cuore & circol., 1927, 11: 309-21.—Levine, S. A., & Curtiss, A. N. A case of ventricular tachycardia and auric- ular fibriUation; an unusual problem in therapy. Am. Heart J., 1925-26, 1: 413-20.—Perkins, O. C. Auricular fibriUation associated with apoplexy. Maine M. J., 1936, 27: 70-4 — Picchini, G. Fibrillazione auricolare in corso di ritmo sinusale. Cuore & circol., 1934, 18: 713-9, 3 ch.—Saylor, E. L. A case of auricular fibriUation complicated by an acute intestinal obstruc- tion. J. Kansas M. Soc, 1927, 27: 84.—Shookhov, C. Ventric- ular fibrillation with cardiac recovery, caused by carotid sinus pressure, in a case of auricular fibrillation. Am. Heart J., 1931, 6: 758-67. ---- Fibrillation: Diagnosis. D'Ornano, A. I. H. *Du diagnostic clinique de l'arythmie complete. 122p. 8? Par., 1932. Arrillaga, F. C, & Solari, A. V. Estudio radio-kimogr&fico HEART AURICLE 229 HEART AURICLE en la fibrilaci6n auricular. Sem. med., B. Air., 1937, 44: 2-8.— Aubertin. C. Diagnostic pratique de l'arythmie complete. J. med. Paris, 1935, 55: 113.—Cooley, L. E. The diagnosis and clinical significance of auricular fibriUation. J. Iowa M. Soc, 1934, 24: 517-9.—Cossio, P. L'image radiographique de la fibrUlation auriculaire. Rev. sudamer. med., Par., 1932, 3: 19- 28. Also Sem. m6d., B. Air., 1932, 39: 1583-9.—Cozzolino, T. F. Diagn6stico y tratamiento de la arritmia completa. Dia med. urug., 1933, 1: 66-8.—De Castro, O. Flutter et fibrilla- tions partielles; avantages d'un diagnostic precoce. Arch. mal. cceur, 193, 27: 282-96.—Fowler, W. M„ & Baldridge, C. W. Auricular fibrillation as the only manifestation of heart disease. Am. Heart J., 1930-31, 6: 183-91.—Golston, H. Auricular fibriUation; clinical significance. Virginia M. Month., 1936-37, 63: 428-31.—Grosz, D. [Oscillometric examination of the pulse in absolute arrhythmia] Budapesti orv. ujs., 1937, 35: 392-4. Also Deut. med. Wschr., 1937, 63: 438.—Luten, D., & Jeffreys, E. O. The cUnical significance of auricular fibrillation. J. Am. M. Ass., 1936, 107: 2099-102.—Mandelstam, M. E. [CUnical diagnosis of fibrillar arhythmia] Ter. arkh., 1936, 14: 270-80.—Routier, D., & Heim de Balsac, R. A propos de l'aspect radiologique du coeur dans l'arythmie complete. BuU. Soc. radiol. med. France, 1933, 21: 737. ---- Fibrillation: Electrocardiography. Bayer, O., & Wasmuht, K. The duration of the Q-T inter- val in absolute arrhythmia. Am. Heart J., 1941, 22: 841 (Abstr.)—Langeron, L. Troubles electriques de la contraction auriculaire precedant la fibriUation de l'oreillette; existenced'un stade pre-fibriUatoire. Arch. mal. cceur, 1932, 25: 34-9.— Luisada, A. Variable interval between electric and acoustic phenomena in auricular fibriUation. Am. Heart J., 1941, 22: 245-51.—Markovits, F. [Auricular fibrillation in dorso- ventral lead] Orv. hetil., 1935, 79: 268.—Penati, F. Elektro- kardiographischer Befund von Herzflimmern bei plotzUchem Herztod. Klin. Wschr., 1933, 12: 1249-51.—Rothberger, C. J., & Winterberg, H. Ueber den Pulsus irregularis perpetuus; Bemerkungen zu der Mitteilung Herings: Ueber das Fehlen der Vorhofzacke im Elektrokardiogramm beim Irregularis per- petuus. Wien. klin. Wschr., 1909, 22: 1792-5.—Rubino, A. Fluttuazioni e fibriUazioni parziaU degU atri documentate col sistema deUe derivazioni elettive. Cuore & circol., 1936, 20: 57-65.—Somer, E. de. De la difficulte de Interpretation de la fibriUation auriculaire (flimmern, flattern) dans l'ecg: ondula- tions du z€ro electrique. Cardiologia, Basel, 1937, 1: 336-48. ---- Fibrillation: Etiology. See also names of primary diseases as Blood pressure, high; Heart muscle, Fibrosis; Mitral valve, Stenosis; Thyrotoxicosis, &c. Weber, P. [J.] *Pulsus irregularis perpetus und Trauma. 28p. 8? Koln, 1936. Abdulaev, D. M. [Pathogenesis of auricular fibrillation in arteriosclerosis of the heart] Ter. arkh., 1935, 13: 181-96.— Bazan, J. Fibrilaci6n auricular transitoria o paroxistica durante el embarazo. Bol. Soc. obst. gin. B. Aires. 1931, 10: 508-11 — Bishop, L. F., & Bishop, L. F., jr. Observations of the clinical course of arteriosclerotic auricular fibrillation. N. York State J. M, 1936, 36: 156-8.—Bosanquet. A cas? of mitral and aortic disease with auricular fibrillation complicated by chronic pulmonary tuberculosis. Brompton Hosp. Rep., Lond., 1934, 3: 149.—Brill, I. C. Auricular fibrillation with congestive failure and no other evidence of organic heart disease. Am. Heart J., 1937, 13: 175-82. ------ Etiology and treatment of auricular fibrillation and auricular flutter. J. S. Carolina M, Ass., 1937, 33: 126-8. Also Mod. Concepts Card. Dis., 1937, 6: No. 3, 1. ------& Meissner, W. A. The role of coronary arterv disease in the etiology of auricular fibrillation. Ann. Int. M., 1940-41, 14: 1341-7.—Brockbmk, E. M. Trauma as a cause of auricular fibrillation. Brit. M. J., 1927, 1: 698.— Campbell, M. The etiology of auricular fibrillation. Guy's Hosp. Rep., Lond., 1929, 79: 261-76.—Cookson, H. The aetiology and prognosis of auricular fibrillation. Q. J. Med., Oxf., 1929-30, 23: 309-25.—Cowan, J. The causes of auricular fibrillation. Ibid., 1928-29, 22: 237-45, 2 pl—Evans. W. A. Long-standing cases of auricular fibrillation with organic heart disease; some cUnical considerations. Ann. Int. M., 1935-36. 9: 1171-7.—Felberbaum, D., & Finesilver, B. Transient auricular fibrillation in abdominal diseases. Am. Heart J., 1926-27, 2: 416-23.—Fishberg, A. M. Auricular fibrillation and flutter in metastatic growths of the right auricle. Am. J. M. Sc, 1930, 180: 629-34.—Friedlander. R. D., & Levine, S. A. Auricular fibriUation and flutter without evidence of organic heart disease. N. England J. M., 1934, 211: 624-9, ch — Hare, E. H. Mitral stenosis with auricular fibrillation asso- ciated with paresis. U. S. Veterans Bur. M. Bull., 1926, 2: 1172-4.—Harris, I. Trauma as a cause of auricular fibrillation. Brit. M. J., 1927, 1: 984.—Hay, J. Trauma as a cause of auric- ular fibrillation. Ibid., 817. ------& Jones, H. W. Trauma as a cause of auricular fibrillation; its medico-legal significance. Ibid., 559-62.—Hutcheson, W. C. An anatomic basis for auricular fibrillation. Arch. Path.. Chic. 1941, 31: 369-72.— Iglauer, A., Davis, D., & Altschule, M. D. Auricular fibrillation in normal, intact animals after the intravenous injection of mecholyl, acetyl-/S-methylcholine. Am. Heart J., 1941, 22: 47-55.—Jervell, A. Traumatisk opstatt forkammerflimmer. Norsk mag. laegevid., 1933, 94: 14-7.—Kanki, Y. Auricular fibrillation in puerperium. Jap. J. Obst., 1929, 12: 66-8, pl.— Laszlo, B. [Why is perpetual arrhythmia so infrequent in patients with luetic aortitis?] Gy6gyaszat, 1938, 78: 409-11.— Mohler, H. K., & Crawford, B. L. Pathologic changes in the heart in auricular fibrillation. Am. J. M. Sc, 1934, 187: 171-6 Lp-;TNahum' L> H- & Hoff> H- E- Production of auricular fibrillation by application of acetvl-0-methylcholine chloride to localized regions on the auricular surface. Am. J. Physiol., 1940, 129: 428.—Palacio, J. Arritmia completa por fibrilo- flutter en una enfermedad mitral, con insuficiencia ventricular derecha. Prensa med. argent., 1926-27, 13: 920-31.—Reid, W. D. Auricular fibrillation in an apparently normal heart. Boston M. & S. J., 1927, 197: 1213-5.—Robinson, A. L. The effect of parturition on the heart; with a report on 18 cases of pregnancy complicated with auricular fibrillation [statistics] Lancet, Lond., 1927, 1: 170-3—Royer de Vericourt, E. Aspects etiologiques de l'arythmie complete. Rev. med., Par., 1937, 54: 495-510.—Schellong. Totale Irregularitiit des Herzens (Vor- hofflimmern) aus toxischen und nervosen Ursachen. Munch. med. Wschr., 1926, 73: 1597. Also KUn. Wschr., 1927, 6: 93.—Scherwin, J. [Case of post-traumatic transitory auricular fibriUation] Ugeskr. laeger, 1941, 103: 1031-4.—Slesinger, E. G. Auricular fibrillation and the thyroid. Brit. M. J., 1939, 1: 65-7. Also Guy's Hosp. Gaz., Lond., 1941, 55: 237-9 — Smith, H. L. A study of the incidence of auricular fibrUlation. Minnesota M., 1932, 15: 403-6.—Stephens, G. A. Auricular fibrUlation; a suggestion as to its cause. Med. J. & Rec, 1928, 127: 300-2.—Stroud, W. D., & Reisinger, J. A. The etiology, diagnosis, treatment and prognosis of auricular fibrillation. Tr. CoU. Physicians Philadelphia, 1929, 51: 84-94.—Sussman, M. L., & Woodruff. M. T. The significance of left auricular dilatation in auricular fibrillation. Am. J. Roentg., 1938, 40: 184-8.—Wallace, H. L. Auricular fibrUlation associated with a mitral stenotic murmur. Edinburgh M. J., 1930, 37: 303- 6.—Walzer, L. Incidence of auricular fibrillation in mitral stenosis with congestive failure. Ohio M. J., 1940, 36: 281-3. Also repr.—Wedd, A. M., & Mullins, W. L. The incidence of auricular fibriUation. Clifton M. BuU., 1932, 18: 97-103. Also repr.—Vater, W. M. Pathologic changes in auricular fibrUlation and in aUied arrhythmias. Arch. Int. M., 1929, 43: 808-34. ---- Fibrillation, juvenile. See also Heart rheumatism. Barber, E. W., & Middleton, R. P. Auricular fibrillation in childhood; report of cases. Am. J. Dis. Child., 1928, 35: 420- 6.—Benjamin, J. E., & Seinsheimer, F. S. Auricular fibrUla- tion and lobar pneumonia in a 10-year-old boy. J. Med., Cincin., 1934, 15: 142.—Codvelle, Andrieu & Henrion. Deux cas d'arythmie complete juvenile d'origine indeterminee. Bull. Soc. med. h6p. Paris, 1935, 3. ser., 51: 1745-9.—Cookson, H. Auricular fibrillation in children. Lancet, Lond., 1929, 2: 1139.—Diaz Nielsen, J. R., Lauers, R., & Waisbein, S. Fibri- lacion auricular cr6nica en la infancia. Arch, argent, pediat., 1941, 15: 554-78. Also Sem. med., B. Air., 1941, 48: 1125-36.— Gibson, S. Auricular fibrillation in childhood and adolescence. Am. J. Dis. Chita., 1941, 61: 651-3. Also J. Am. M. Ass., 1941, 117: 96-8. Also Proc. Inst. M. Chicago, 1940-41, 13: 276.— Goldbloom, A., & Segall.H.N. Auricular fibrUlation in infancy; report of its occurrence in a 3-month old infant, perhaps starting before birth. Am. J. Dis. Child., 1938, 56: 587-93.—Hecht, F. Vorhofflimmern im Kindesalter. Wien. med. Wschr., 1935, 85: 1002.—Jenkins, S. F., & Owens, N. Auricular fibrUlation in childhood; report of case treated by quinidine sulphate. Arch. Pediat., N. Y., 1933, 50: 479-81—Leys, D. G., & Russell, H. B. \ case of persistent auricular fibriUation in a child of 6. Lancet, Lond., 1927, 2: 702.—Migliori, V. Considerazioni sulla fibrilla- zione auricolare infantile e giovanile. Med. inf., Roma, 1938, 9: 230-42.—Resnik, W. H., & Scott, W. J. Auricular fibrilla- tion; report of a case in a child aged 4 years. Am. J. Dis. Child. 1926, 31: 357-9. Also repr.—Schwartz, S. P., & Weiss, M. M., Auricular fibrillation in children; its relation to rheumatic heart disease. Ibid., 1928, 36: 22-39. ---- Fibrillation: Manifestation. See also Heart disease, Manifestation; Heart rate, Tachycardia; Heart sound, Murmur. &c. Arnoldi. W. Die Ermittlung von dominierenden Rhythmen sowie der schwere der Rhythmusstorung bei Kranken mit Arhythmia perpetua. KUn. Wschr., 1927, 6: 1846-8.— Eggleston, C. The persistence of a mitral stenotic murmur in the presence of auricular fibrillation. Am. J. M. Sc, 1929, 177: 153-61.—Hoesslin, H. von. Die zeitlichen Verhaltnisse der bei Vorhofflimmern auftretenden Extrasystolen. Zschr. Kreislaufforsch., 1933, 25: 681-91.—Hyman, A. S. Idiopathic vomiting in auricular fibrillation. Am. Med., 1927, 22: 469- 75.—King, H. C. The clinical aspects of auricular fibrUlation. J. Med., Cincin., 1938-39, 19: 559-66.—Holier, S. Wahr- scheinlichkeitstheoretische Berechnungen iiber Parasystolic bei Vorhofflimmern. Verh. Deut. Ges. Kreislaufforsch., 1937, 10: 285-93.—Rihl, J. Experimentelle Untersuchungen iiber den Ausdruck des Flimmerns der Vorhofe im Venenpulse. Zschr. exp. Path., Lpz., 1910-11, 8: 446-50, pl.—Selenin, W. F., & Fogelson, L. I. Das Phonogramm bei Vorhofflimmern. Zschr. Kreislaufforsch., 1929, 21: 177-85.—Svab, V. [Wenckebach's period in auricular fibrillation] Cas. lek. 6esk., 1936, 75: 70-3.— HEART AURICLE 230 HEART AURICLE Wedd, A. M. Abdominal symptoms of heart disease, with special reference to the role of auricular fibrillation. Surg. Gyn. Obst., 1927. 45: 790-4.—Zedda, G. Bigeminismo pseudo- ritmico da fibrillazione auricolare; contributo alia conoscenza dei bigeminismi cardiaci. Cuore & circol., 1939, 23: 290-7. ---- Fibrillation: Pathogenesis. Vndreev, S. V.. Borisova, E. I., & Rusiiiov, V. S. [On the multiple centers in auricular fibrUlation] BiuU. eksp, biol. med., 1941, 11: 137-9.—Andrus, E. C, & Carter, E. P. The refrac- tory period of the normaUy-beating dog's auricle; with a note on the occurrence of auricular fibrillation following a single stimu- lus. J. Exp. M., 1930, 51: 357-67, pl.— Benaros, M. Los trastornos prefibrUatorios de las auriculas. Prensa med. argent., 1936, 23: 2457-50.—Block, M. The earUest correlation of cUnical and experimental auricular fibrillation. Am. Heart J., 1939, 18: 684-91. Also Univ. Hosp. Bull., Ann Arb., 1939, 5: 75.—Boer, S. de. Neue Experimente iiber das Wesen des Vorhofflimmerns. Deut. med. Wschr., 1938, 64: 1067 — Calabresi, M., & Picchini, G. Complessi ventricolari di forma variabile nella fibrUlazione e nella vibrazione auricolare. Gior. clin. med., 1931, 12: 1115-40.—Campbell, E. E. Auric- ular fibriUation; mechanism, diagnosis, and treatment. Ohio M. J., 1937, 33: 54-8.—Dagnini, G. L'attivita auricolare prefibriUatoria. Cuore & circol., 1937, 21: 571-87, graph.— Duclos, F. L'anarchie auriculaire comme etat prefibrillatoire. Arch. mal. coeur, 1935, 28: 393-403.—Gautrelet, J., & Halpern, N. FibriUation auriculaire exp6rimentale et adrenaline. C. rend. Soc. biol., 1932, 110: 931.—Haberlandt, L. Ueber ein Hormon der Herzbewegung; iiber den Erregungsstoff beim Herzwiihlen. Arch. ges. Physiol., 1927, 216: 778-88.—Harri- son, F. F. Auricular fibriUation apparently caused by tension on the wall of the right auricle. In CUn. Misc. Bassett Hosp., 1934, 1: 136-45.—Koumans, A. K. J. Die Entstehung von Vorhofflimmern und Blockzustanden auf Grund neuer An- schauungen iiber die Reizbildung im Herzmuskel. Arch. Kreislaufforsch., 1937-38, 2: 327-48.—Kupas, J. Zur Frage der Arrhythmia absoluta. Munch, med. Wschr., 1939, 86: 206.—Lombardini, V. Contribuci6n al estudio de la fibrilaci6n auricular. Dia med., B. Air., 1936, 8: 1112.—Mentl, S., & Jarolim, V. [Auricular coordination and action in auricular fibrillation] Cas. 16k. Cesk., 1941, 80: 221; 276.—Moe, G. K., & Harris, A. S. Repetitive focal discharges and conduction changes related to the induction of ventricular fibrillation. Am. J. Physiol., 1941, 133: 390. ------ & Wiggers, C. J. Analysis of the initiation of fibrUlation by electrographic studies. Ibid., 134: 473-92.—Nahum, L. H., & Hoff, H. E. The role of the vagus in the genesis of auricular fibrUlation. Yale J. Biol., 1934-35, 7: 361.—Pace, D. La fibrillation auricu- laire normale de la taupe et son tisssu nodal particulier; noeud gangho-neuro-musculaire; recherches histologiques et eiectro- graphiques. Arch. mal. cceur, 1934, 27: 657-90, 2 pl.—Scherf, D. Zur Theorie des Vorhofflatterns und Vorhofflimmerns. Verh. Deut. Ges. Kreislaufforsch., 1928, 180-4 [Discussion] 186-8.—Smith, H. L. Auricular fibrillation: mechanism, significance, incidence and treatment. Med. Clin. N. America, 1935, 19: 511-5.—Stiller, A. [Pathogene§is of auricular fibrillation] Warsz. czas. lek., 1936, 13: 361-3. [Transitory auricular fibriUation and its significance in the pathogenesis of permanent auricular fibrUlation] Ibid., 1937, 14: 761; 786—Wegria, R., Geyer, J. H.. & Brown, B. S. The mechanism of ventricular fibrillation after digitalis. Am. J. Physiol., 1941, 133: 485. ---- Fibrillation: Physiopathology. Calman, S. *Diagnostic de l'insumsance du ventricule gauche dans l'arythmie complete. 62p. 8? Par., 1926. Addarii. F. Ueber den Einfluss der Flimmerarrhythmie auf den MUchsaurestoffwechsel des Herzens. Arch, internat. pharm. dyn., Par., 1937, 57: 133-8.—Aryev, M. [Pulsus de- ficiens and its cUnical importance] Vrach. gaz., 1923 27- 491.—Buchbinder, W. C, & Sugarman, H. The arterial blood pressure in auricular fibrillation, measured directly. Am J Physiol., 1940, 129: 323. Also Arch. Int. M., 1940, 66: 625-^ 42—Crawford. J H-> & Rosenberger, H. Studies on human capularies; observations in cases of auricular fibriUation. J Clin. Invest., 1925-26, 2: 365-74.—Estape, F. de A. Sobre la signincaciOn chnica del pulsdeficit. Rev. med. Barcelona 1926 2. ser., 5i 542-60.—Kerkhof, A. C, & Baumann, H. Minute volume determinations in mitral stenosis during auricular fabrication al?d when restored to normal rhythm. Proc. Soc Exp. Biol., V \ 1933 31: 168-70.—Roth, O. Klinische Untersuchungen uber die Ventrikeltatigkeit bei Vorhofflimmern \erh. Deut. Ges. inn. Med., 1927, 39. Kongr., 136-42 — Stewart. H. J., i Gilchrist, A. R. Studies on the effect of cardiac irregularity on the circulation; the estimation of cardiac output in dogs subject to artificial auricular fibrillation J Clin. Invest., 1928, 5: 335-12.------& Crawford j H ■studies on the effect of cardiac irregularity on the circulation the relation of pulse deficit to rate of blood flow in dogs subject Ibid 3t 7a\-fUn«rUar fib"IlaVon ^d to regular tachycardia. I »" rL PfWf 'fT^ "• i-' CrawLford' J- H- & Hastings off„„; J ?f?Ct of tachycardia on the blood flow in dogs- the !bfd te27.T&r7.y ** Se°" ^ aU,i'",ar nbr'»alion ---- Fibrillation: Prognosis. Camail, H. *Etude du pronostic dc l'arythmie complete. 108p. 8? Par., 1927. Bishop, L. F., & Bishop, L. F., jr. Auricular fibrillation observed for 25 years. J. Am. M. Ass., 1940, 114: 955.— Boas. E. P. Recurrence of paroxismal auricular fibrillation after permanent relief of hyperthyroidism by subtotal thy- roidectomy. Ibid., 1936, 106: 2238. Burch. G. E. Auricular fibrUlation of 22 months' duration, with return to normal sinus mechanism without the aid of quinidine. Am. Heart J., 1939, 18: 102-7.—Clerc. A., & Stieffel, R. Pronostic de l'aryth- mie complete. BuU. Soc. med. hop. Paris, 1927, 3. ser., 51: 1139-47.—Flaxman, N. Auricular fibrillation; its influence on the course of hypertensive heart disease. J. Am. M. Ass., 1937, 108: 797-9. Also repr.—Jones, H. W. Some points in the prognosis of auricular fibrillation. Lancet, Lond., 1926, 2: 040.—Katz, G. I. [On the prognosis of fibrillating arrhythmia Orlcss. med. J., 1928, 3: 598-600.—Laslett. E. E. A case of auricular fibrillation of 15 years' duration. Lancet, Lond., 1927, 1: 1290.—Lee, T. S. Auricular fibrillation, with a report of a long-standing case. Tr. Am. Ther. Soc. (1939) 1940, 39: 105-9.—O'Grady, P. J. S. A case of auricular fibrillation with recovery. J. R. Army M. Corps, 1937, 68: 401-3.— Orgain, E. S., Wolff, L., & White, P. D. UncompUcated auricular fibrillation and auricular flutter; frequent occurrence and good prognosis in patients without other evidence of cardiac disease. Arch. Int. M., 1936, 57: 493-513.—Rothstadt, L. E. The effect of auricular fibrillation on the course of hypertension. Med. J. AustraUa, 1938, 1: 813-8.—Strauss, A. E. Improving the prognosis in auricular fibrillation. In J. H. Pratt Anniv. Vol., 1937, 964-6.—Willius, F. A., & Dry, T. J. The prognosis of auricular fibrillation of undetermined origin. J. Am. M. Ass.. 1941, 117: 330-2. ---- Fibrillation: Sequelae. Hoskin, J. The effect of auricular fibrillation on the opera- tive risk in hyperthyroidism. Brit. M. J., 1930, 2: 138.— Ruiz, R., & Guiterman, M. Fibrilaci6n auricular y afasia. Sem. med., B. Air., 1940, 47: 211-8.—Winternitz, M., & Stern, O. L. Ein Fall von Vorhofstillstand nach Vorhofflimmern Wien. Arch. inn. Med., 1931, 21: 303-10.—Zuidema. [Hemi- paresis caused by embolus in cardiac fibrillation] Geneesk tschr. Ned. Indie. 1939, 79: 312-6. ---- Fibrillation: Treatment. Breitenbach, W. *ExperimenteIle Unter- suchungen liber die Einwirkung verschiedener Arzneimittel auf das durch faradische Ileizung erzeugte Flimmern am isolierten Froschherzen 43p. 8? Erlangen, 1936. Heilemann, H. *Zur Behandlung der Arhythmia absoluta. 18p. 8? Lpz., 1937. Aitoff. Traitement de l'arythmie complete. Bull. g6n thir 1936 187: 294-300.—Aubert, H. [Treatment of auricular fibrillation] Rev. st. med., Bucur., 1934, 23: 1031-7.—Beck, H.\ G- Myocardial insufficiency with auricular fibrillation relieved by pelvic lavage for an associated pyelitis. Tr. Am ?,&?• fSS' #?2P 1928' 28: 98-102. Also Med. J. & Rec, 1927, 126: 31-3.-Bedford, D. E., Campbell, M., & Wood, F. H. Ihe treatment of auricular fibrillation with strophanthin emiru. Guy s Hosp. Rep., Lond., 1935, 85: 185-90.—Bower- ban.k- *• *• ..P0?16 Points in the diagnosis and treatment of auricular fibrillation. N. Zealand M. J., 1928-29 27-368-74 — Bramwell. J C. Treatment of auricular fibrillation. Brit. M. J., 1928, 2: 795.—Brill, I. C. Treatment of auricular fibrilla- tion and auricular flutter. Northwest M., 1937 36- 79-82 — Brugsch, T. & Klingmuller, M. FUmmerarhythmien und ihre Behandlung. THer. Gegenwart, 1929, 70: 289-94 — Campbell, M Auricular fibrillation and its treatment. Guy's Hosp Gaz Lond., 1938, 52: 178-84.—Clerc. A. L'arythmie complete et son traitement. Marseille med., 1926, 63: 601- ,,4- ~.-- & Stieffel, R. Traitement medicamenteux de 1 arythmie complete Prat. med. fr., 1927, 6: No. 2(A) 59-62.— Lotton, 1. h The treatment of auricular fibrillation and flutter. Practitioner, Lond., 1933, 130: 698-704.—Doljan, ('. rireatment of auricular fibriUation with carbonic acid baths] ni^rf1' 193,' !7= 398-402.-East, T. The treatment of persistent auricular fibrillation and flutter. Brit. M. J., 1935, L2?, Ai?° In»Tre£t- Gen- Praot., 2. ed., Lond., 1938, 1: wJ^;a;~l5^•!y, ™ JWe4erIl,und Therapie der total irregularen Herztatigkeit. Med. Welt, 1930, 4: 1136.—Frommel, E. r£« xll% ^e ^1^Tyt^mie complete. Rev. med. Suisse en^ul936'D56: 76*77-rG' P- Traitement de l'arythmie complete. Presse med., 1940, 48: 543.-Gaquiere, A. Traite- n Pi « L arythmie complete. Hopital, 1939, 27: 203-6- hV ii?-" i ' ^- Tu[et £L1 0n vaSal and extravagal factors fiKr^oT1 HTv8 rby ^gitalia in Patients with auricular fibrillation. J. Clin. Invest., 1939, 18: 429-37. ------ Physi- h?£?Jr adaPtit.10ns in cardiac slowing by digitalis and their bearing on problems of digitization in patients with auricular fibriUation. J. Pharm. Exp. Ther., 1939, 67: 224-38.—Grundig. KlirP'wkS° fo^orh,y,th?ieodef Herzens und ihre Behandlung. ^Trfe',,^ il.■■ii ?3Vi- 12u32-5.-Katz. G. I. [Treatment of auricular fibrillation] \ rach. gaz., 1931, 35: 430-3 —Kienle F HEART AURICLE 231 HEART AURICLE Die naturheilerische Behandlung der Arrhythmia absoluta. Med. Welt, 1940, 14: 941-3.—Kushelevsky, B. P., & Gorbu- nova, Z. V. [Active therapy in fibrillar arrhythmia] Ter. arkh., 1936, 14: 261-9.—Langley, G. J. The nature and treat- ment of auricular fibrillation. Brit. M. J., 1927, 1: 1043-6.— Levine, S. A. The treatment of auricular fibrillation. Rhode Island M. J., 1926, 9: 19-22.—Lian, C. Tratamiento de la arritmia completa. Dfa med., B. Air., 1931-32, 4: 595.— Modell, W., & Gold, H. The use of digitalis to prevent the exaggerated acceleration of the heart during physical exercise in patients with auricular fibrillation. J. Pharm. Exp. Ther., 1941, 72: 29. Also J. Am. M. Ass., 1941, 116: 2241-4.— Olshausen, W. Die Arrhythmia absoluta und ihre Behandlung. Zbl. inn. Med., 1929, 50: 850-9.—Perrin, M., & Richard, G. Pronostic et traitement de l'arythmie complete. BuU. gin. ther., 1931, 182: 433-9.—Prusik, B., & Volicer, L. [X-ray therapy in auricular fibriUation] Cas. lek. desk., 1927, 66: 688.—Roffo, A. H., & Lopez-Ramirez, R. L'action du rubidium sur la fibrillation mecanique et 61ectrique de l'auricule. J. physiol. path, gen., 1926, 24: 519-24.—Romberg, E. Ueber die Behandlung der perpetuellen (absoluten) Arrhythmie. Ther. Gegenwart, 1931, 72: 15-8.—Routier, D., & Walser, J. Le traitement de l'arythmie complete. Bull, med., Par., 1927, 41: 362-70.—Rykert, H. E., & Hepburn, J. The use of stro- phanthin in the treatment of auricular fibrillation. Canad. M. Ass. J., 1936, 34: 281-3.—Siemelink, R. J. Vergleichende Untersuchung iiber die Wirkung von Medikamenten auf das Vorhofflimmern. Zschr. ges. exp. Med., 1937, 101: 87-102.— Smith, H. L. The advisabiUty of restoring normal rhythm in patients who have auricular fibrUlation. Med. CUn. N. America, 1940, 24: 1083-8.—Stand, O. Wirkung der Digi- norgin-Suppositorien auf komplette Arhythmien (Vorhofflim- mern) und ein Fall von Vorhofflattern. Med. KUn., Berl., 1927, 23: 361-4.—Stroud, W. D., & Laplace. L. B. The signifi- cance and treatment of auricular fibrillation. Internat. CUn., 1935, 45. ser., 1: 13-38. Also repr.—Wallace, E. W. Effect of acetylchoUne, derivatives, and certain other drugs upon artifically induced auricular fibriUation in the intact dog. J. Pharm. Exp. Ther., 1941, 72: 43.—Wedd, A. M., & Drury, A. N. Veratrum viride in auricular fibrUlation. Heart, Lond., 1925-26, 12: 307-19.—Weinstein, W., Plaut. J., & Katz, L. N. Limitations of the use of digitalis for ambulatory patients with auricular fibrUlation. Am. J. M. Sc, 1940, 199: 498-505.— Woodruff, P. FoUnerin in cardiac failure with auricular fibrilla- tion. Melbourne Hosp. CUn. Rep., 1939, 10: 74-81. --- Fibrillation: Treatment: Quinidine and quinine. Bulte, O. *Erfahrungen mit der Chinidin- Therapie bei der Arhythmia perpetua. 15p. 8? Wurzb., 1930. Vollert, E. F. *Quinidine sulphate in auricu- lar fibrillation [St Mary's Hospital] 55 1. 4? S. Franc, 1929. Anderson, J. P. The incidence of auricular fibrUlation and results of quinidine therapy. Am. Heart J., 1932, 8: 128-33.— Anderson, W. M. Some experiences with quinidin in auricular fibriUation. U. S. Nav. M. BuU., 1931, 29: 446-58.—Barrieu. Sulfate de quinidine et arythmie complete. Bull. Soc. med. Paris, 1937, 202-8.—Barry, G. Arythmie complete et quini- dine. Union med. Canada, 1933, 62: 1228-36.—Bertucci. J. P. Quinidine therapy; its use in long-standing auricular fibriUa- tion with congestive failure. Wisconsin M. J., 1941, 40: 292-5.—Bevan-Brown, F. V., & Gray, M. Case of paroxysmal fibrillation controlled with quinidine. N. Zealand M. J., 1928-29, 27: 134.—Bijlsma, U. G., & Van Dongen, K. Die Wirkung von Chinidin und Hydrochinidin auf das experi- mentelle Vorhofflimmern. Arch, internat. pharm. dyn., Par., 1939, 63: 90-4.—Bose, A. K. Quinidine therapy in auricular fibrUlation; with a case report. Calcutta M. J., 1940, 37: 764-8.—Brucke. K. Ueber die Behandlung der Arhythmia absoluta, besonders mit Chinidin. Ther. Gegenwart, 1939, 80: 100-4.—Bulte & Reinwein. Erfahrungen mit der Chini- dintherapie bei der Arhythmia perpetua. Med. Klin., Berl., 1930, 26: 1751.—Campbell, M., & Gordon, F. W. The quini- dine treatment of auricular fibrillation. Q. J. Med., Lond., 1936, 5: 205-26.—Clerc, A. La quinine et la quinidine dans le traitement de l'arythmie complete. In Ther. mid. (Loeper, M.) Par., 1933, 6: 194-212.—Cowley, R. J. La quinidina en el tratamiento de la fibrilaci6n auricular. Rev. med. cir. Habana, 1934, 39: 644-50. Also Rev. med., Rosario, 1935, 9: 32-6.—Duffy, M. J. Quinidin in the treatment of auricular fibriUation. Med. CUn. N. America, 1926, 9: 1199-206 — Eismayer. Ueber die Chinidinbehandlung der Arhythmia perpetua. Munch, med. Wschr., 1927, 74: 1298.—Ernstene, A. C, & Dinsmore, R. S. The use of quinidine for auricular fibrillation in hyperthyroidism. Cleveland Clin. Q., 1940, 7: 135-7.—Estape, F. de|A. Sobre la correction real y aparente de la arritmia de fibrilacion por la quinidina. Ars medica, Barcel., 1929, 5: 153-63.—Etcheves, J. C. Fibrilaci6n auricular facU- mente modificable por la quinidina. Rev. med., B. Air., 1939, 1: 62-4.—Gold, H., Otto, H. L.. & Satchwell, H. The use of quinidine in ambulatory patients for the prevention of paroxysms of auricular flutter and fibriUation; with especial reference to dosage and the effects on intraventricular conduction. Am. Heart J., 1933, 9: 219-37.—Harris, K. E. A series of cases of auricular fibrillation treated with quinidine sulphate, with special reference to the duration of the restored normal mech- anism. Heart, Lond., 1928-29, 14: 283-8.—Hilbish, T. F. the use of quinidine in auricular fibrillation; with report of a case. Hosp. News, Wash., 1939, 6: No. 12, 13-22, pl— Hines, L. E., & Maher, C. C. A study of quinidin effects on ™ T^o01"^3^1118 with auricular fibrUlation. J. Lab. Clin. M 1933, 19: 232.—Hurxthal, L. M. Auricular fibrfflationdn patients with goiter; value of quinidin based on the study of 114 case| Am. J. M. Sc, 1930, 179: 507-19.—Kohn, C. M., & Levine, S. A. An evaluation of the use of quinidine sulphate rP.-Po1"!18*6,?* auncular fibriUation. Ann. Int. M., 1934-35, 8: 923-38.—Konstam, G. L. S. A case of auricular fibriUation restored to normal rhythm with quinidine; also a case of auricular flutter with mitral and aortic stenosis and aortic incompetence. West London M. J., 1934, 39: 100.—Langeron. Action de la digitaline et de la quinidine dans la fibrillation auriculaire et l'arythmie complete. J. sc. med. Lille, 1928, 46: 209.—Lawrence, R. L. Quinidine therapy in auricular fibriUa- M0n'ioW report of cases. Hosp. News, Wash., 1939, 6: No. 18, 14-22, 2 pl.—Lian, C. De la quinidine dans l'arythmie complete; ses resultats durables grace k la cure d'entretien. C. rend. Congr. fr. med., 1922, 16. sess., 292-8. ------ La quinine dans le traitement de l'arythmie complete et les tachy- cardies paroxystiques. Ibid., 1923, 17. sess., 71.------ Blondel, A. [et al.] Le sulfate de quinidine dans le traitement de 1 arythmie complete (indications et contre-indications) incidents et accidents. J. mid. fr., 1928, 17: 227-32.—Lian, C, Blondel, A., & Viau, O. Le sulfate de quinidine dans l'arythmie complete; technique et resultats. Ibid., 232-6.—McCowen, G. R. Quinidine therapy in auricular fibrUlation: 2 successful cases with electrocardiographic evidence. J. R. Nav. M. Serv., 1933, 19: 101-5.—Martin Rodriguez, F. Un caso de arritmia completa curada con quinidina. An. Hosp. S. Jose, Madr., 1929-30, 1: 273-5.—Maynard, E. P. Five years' experience in the treatment of chronic auricular fibriUation with quinidin sulphate. Am. J. M. Sc, 1928, 175: 55-60.—Meldolesi, G. Sul meccanismo di azione deUa chinina e della chinidina nella fibriUazione e nella vibrazione delle orecchiette. PoUcUnico 1926, 33: sez. prat., 1209-14.—Morrison, J. R. Case of auricu- lar fibriUation treated with quinidine. Kentucky M. J., 1929, 27: 61-3.—Newman, W. W., & Spiro, H. Quinidine therapy in auricular fibrillation; an evaluation based on its use over a 6-year period. CaUfornia West. M., 1932, 37: 19-25.— Parkinson, J., & Campbell, M. The quinidine treatment of auricular fibrUlation. Quart. J. M., Oxf., 1928-29, 22: 281- 303.—Schuize, K. Zur Chinintherapie der Arhythmia abso- luta. Deut. med. Wschr., 1938, 64: 530-4.—Sidel, N., & Dorwart, F. G. Quinidin sulphate in auricular fibriUation. Boston M. & S. J., 1927, 196: 216-24.—Siemianowski, S., & Rachon, K. [Complete arrhythmia; treatment with quinidin] Polska gaz. lek., 1926, 5: 279-81.—Smith, H. L., & Boland, E. W. The treatment of auricular fibriUation with quinidine and strychnine; report of 41 cases. J. Am. M. Ass., 1939, 113: 1017-22.—Sokolow, M. Quinidine in the treatment of benign auricular fibrUlation with repeated emboU. Am. Heart J. 1939, 18: 494-9.—Stepp, W., & Kirchmann, L. L. Ueber Versuche mit Chinidin-Sympatol zur Behandlung des Vor- hofflimmerns. Munch, med. Wschr., 1939, 86: 433-6 — Stroud, W. D. The value of quinidin sulphate in the treat- ment of auricular fibrillation. Med. Clin. N. America, 1926, 10: 331-53.—Talley, J. E. Recurrent auricular fibriUation rationed on quinidin sulphate. Atlantic M. J., 1925-26, 29: 236.—Tenconi, P. Considerazioni su di un caso di aritmia completa guarito con la chinidina. BoU. spec med. chir., 1929, 3: 9-16.—Tillgren, J., & Bjerlov, H. [Protracted quinine treatment in auricular fibrillation] Sven. lak. tidn., 1933, 30: 278-84.—Tour, A. [Electrocardiographic and clinical observa- tions on fibrillating arrhythmia and treatment with quinidine] Med. biol. J., Leningr., 1929, 5: 64-82.—Weisman, S. A. Auricular fibrUlation; ambulatory treatment with quinidine. Arch. Int. M., 1932, 49: 728-34. Also repr. ----— The ambulatory treatment of auricular fibriUation with quinidine; a 5-year foUow-up study. Minnesota M., 1936, 19: 349-52. CUnical and experimental studies on quinidine; with clinical appUcation as to method of treatment in auricular fibrUlation. Am. Heart J., 1939, 18: [Discussion] 603-6.— Wilson, F. N., Wishart, S. W. [et al.] Nature of abnormal ventricular complexes during quinidin treatment of auricular fibrillation. Proc Soc. Exp. Biol., N. Y., 1925-26, 23: 273-5. Also repr.—Winternitz, M. Zur Chinidintherapie des Vor- hofflimmerns. Med. Klin., Berl., 1932, 28: 1308.—Wolff, L., & White, P. D. Auricular fibrillation; results of 7 years' ex- perience with quinidine sulphate therapy (1921-28) Arch. Int. M., 1929, 43: 653-75. ---- Fibrillation: Type. Habert, V. *Das Vorhofflimmern in seiner schnellen und langsamen Form. 15p. 8? Halle, 1935. Sicks, E. D. *Ueber die Bedeutung der Kammerschlagzahl bei der Arhythmia absoluta (Vorhofflimmern) [Kiel] 12p. 8? Miinch., 1933. Boas, E. P. The ventricular rate in auricular fibrUlation; studies with the cardiotachometer. Am. Heart J., 1928-29, 4: 499-511 — ('arlen, S. A., & Katz, L. N. The ventricular rate HEART AURICLE 232 HEART AURICLE in faradicallv maintained auricular fibrillation; an index of A-V conductivity. Am. J. Physiol., 1939, 127: 272-SO.- Condorelli, L. II polso ritmico nella fibriUazione auricolare. Minerva med., Tor., 1928, 8: 1343-54.—Ferreira, O. Flutter et fibrillations partielles; un aspect nouveau do la pathologie de l'oreillette. Presse med., I'.i35. 43: 260-2.—Herles, F. [Perma- nent and intermitt' 'M auricular fibrillation] Cas. lik. desk., 1932, 71: 1458-lis.- Lian, ('., ifc Golblin, V. La tr6mulation auriculaire; tvpe d'arvthmie intermediaire entre la fibrillation et le flutter des oreillettes. Rev. m6d. fr., 1938, 19: 23-31.— Lian. C, & Pinchenzon, B. La tremulation auriculaire (trouble du rythme intermediaire entre la fibriUation et le flutter) Cardiologia, Basel, 1938, 2: 56-70.—Lian, C, & Welti. J. J. Flutter, ou mieux tremulation auriculaire et bradycardie par dissociation auriculo-ventriculaire complete; audition et enregistrement graphique des bruits auriculaircs. Aich. mal. coeur, 1938, 31: 518-24.—Mosler, E., & Sachs, H. Leber die verschiedenen Formen des Kammerrhythmus (Arlnthmie und Kurhythmie) bei Vorhofflimmern. KUn. Wschr., 1926, 5: 1457-9.—Olyntho de Castro. Nouveaux aspects de la patholo- gie auriculaire; fibrillation et flutter partiels. Arch. mal. coeur, 1937, 30: 207-23.—Rachon, K., & Muszkatenblit, J. [On auricular fibrillation 1:1] Polsk. arch. med. wewn., 1935, 13: 117-26.—Schellong, F.. & Sicks, E. Leber die Bedeutung der Kammerschlagzahl bei der Arhythmia absoluta (Vor- hofflimmern) Munch, med. Wschr., 1933, 80: 378-80. ---- Fibrillation: Type, bradyarrhythmic. Rendu, M. *Les formes bradycardiques permanentes de la fibrillation et du flutter auricu- laircs. 127p. 8? Par., 1936. Bessone, F. Su due casi di aritmia completa lenta. Mi- nerva med., Tor., 1926, 6: 1166-72.—Levy, R. L. Auricular fibrillation with regular ventricular rhythm and rate over 60. Arch. Int. M., 1926, 38: 116-28.—Spangenberg, J. J., Vedoya, R., & Gonzalez Videla, J. Ln caso de fibrilacion auricular coexistiendo con bradycardia muy acentuada. Prensa med. argent., 1937, 24: 1421-4. ---- Fibrillation: Type, paroxystic and tachy- arrhythmic. Overbeck, H. *Beitrag zur Aetiologie, Prognose und Behandlung des anfallsweise anftretenden Vorhofflimmerns und -Flatterns [Giessen] 10p. 22cm. Diisseld., 1938. Arana, R., & Cossio, P. Fibrilaci6n auricular y taquicardia ventricular como eventualidad posible en el P-R corto con QRS ancho y tnellado. Rev. argent, card., 1938, 5: 43-8 — Berard, A. 'Uses de tachyarvthmie tres ameiiorees par la quinidine. Loire med., 1928, 42: 275-9.—Bonorino Udaondo, C., Padilla, T., A- Cossio, P. Fibrilaci6n auricular paroxfstica. Sem. med., B. Air., 1931, 38: 1663-74.—Brugsch, T. Paroxys- males Vorhofflimmern und Vorhofflattern. In Libro de oro M. R. Castex, B. Air., 1938, 2: 199-202.—Cahall, W. L. Paroxysmal ventricular fibrillation. J. Am. M. Ass., 1935, 105: 2051.—Cimpbell, M. Paroxysmal tachycardia and paroxysmal fibrillation. Guy's Hosp. Gaz., Lond., 1932, 46: 308.— Condorelli, L. Tachicardia parossistica e fibrillazione auricolare. Kinase, med., 1928. 5: 789-94.—Crespo Alvarez, A. Fonnas paroxfsticas de fibrilacion auricular. Progr. clin., Madr., 1930, 38: 517-22.—Cushny. A. R., & Edmunds. C. W. Paroxvsmal irregularitv of the heart and auricular fibrillation. In Stud. Path. (Bulloch, W.) Aberdeen, 1906, 95-110.— Donzelot, E. Crise de fibrUlation auriculaire k caractere angoreux. Arch. mal. coeur, 1939, 32: 413-20.—Gallavardin, L., & Veil, P. Constatation chez un mtae sujet de crises successives et alternantes de tachycardie paroxystique et d'arythmie complete. Ibid., 1926, 19: 30-2.—Gerbasi, M. Alcune osservazioni sopra un caso di fibrillazione e di acceleratio auricolare in un bambino. Pediatria (Riv.) 1929, 37: 317-24.— Hendler, I. An unusual case of paroxysmal auricular fibrilla- tion. S. Afr. M. J., 1939, 13: 211.—HoIIingsworth. E. W. Paroxj-smal auricular fibrillation. U. S. Veterans Bur. M. BuU., 1930, 6: 882.—Kauf, E. Zur Analyse der Arhythrnie der Herzkammern bei Vorhofflimmern. Wien. Arch. inn. Med., 1928, 15: 1-28, 9 pl., ch.—Langeron, L. FibriUo- flutter irreductible; tachveardie ventriculaire terminale. Arch. mal. coeur, Par., 1930, 23: 726-8. ------ Arythmie complete paroxystique. J. se. med. Lille, 1930, 48: pt 2, 5-9, pl.—Lyons, R. Some observations on paroxysmal auricu- lar fibrillation. N. Orleans M. & S. J., 1929-30, 82: 357-63 — Mace. N. C. An obscure case of paroxysmal auricular fibrilla- tion with attacks of syncope of long standing. Med. Bull. Veterans Admin., 1939^40, 16: 176.—Mandelstamm, M. E., & Zenzinov, G. S. [Paroxvsmal fibrillar arrhythmia] Ter., arkh., 1935, 13: 21-46—Montoro. O. Fibrilaci6n auricular iiiroxfstica. Arch. Soc. clin. Habana, 1929, 29: 125-9.— Moor, F. Paroxysmal auricular fibrillation. Med. Rec, X. Y., I''38, 148: 184-6.—Mouquin. Les formes paroxvstiques de l'arythmie complete. Medecine, Par., 1926-27, 8: 420-5.— Padilla, T., & Cossio, P. FibriUation auriculaire paroxvstique. Rev. sudamer. med., Par., 1931, 2: 680-97.—Parkinson, J., & Campbell, M. Paroxvsmal auricular fibrillation; a record of 200 patients. Q. J. Med., Oxf., 1930-31, 24: 67-100.—Parsons- Smith, B. T. Paroxysmal auricular fibriUation. Proc. R. Soc. M., Lond., 1928 29, 22: Sect. Clin., 54.— Riderer-Kleemann, M. Beitrag zur Kasuistik der anfallsweise auftretenden perpetuellen Arrhythmie. Med. Klin., Berl., 1926, 22: 997-9.—Roemheld, L., & Tietze. K. Beitrag zur Klinik und zur pathologischen Anatomie der perpetuellen Arhythrnie mit Anfiillen von paroxysmaler Taeb.\ kardie. Zbl. Herz Gefiisskrankh., 1926, 18: 329; 356. Saltzman, F. [Complete irregular heart action or fibriUar arhythmia] Fin. liik. sail, hand., 1937, 80: 295- 312.—Umansky, S. I. [Paroxysmal form of fibrillating ar- rhythmia] Ter. arkh., 1932, 10: 155. ---- Flutter (Auricular tachysystole) Alv&rez-Moulia, A., & Cordero, E. F. E. Flutter auricular. An. Fac med., Montev., 1927, 12: 558-81, diagr., 4 pi.— Bard, L. De la definition et des limites de la tachysystolic auriculaire (auricular flutter) Arch. mal. coeur, 1927, 20: 150-68.—Bishop, L. F. Auricular flutter. Med. J. & Rec, 1926, 123: 814.—Blackhall-Morison, A. The first case of auricular flutter observed. Med. Press & Circ, Lond., 1926, n. ser., 122: 505-7.—Cuervo Barrena, R. Flutter auricular: su mecanismo; sus caracteres clfnicos; su grafica eiectrica. Prensa med., Habana, 1928, 19: 10-3.—Geraudel, E. Tachy- systolie auriculaire et fibrillation auriculaire. Arch. mal. cceur, 1928, 21: 288-95.—Harris, K. E. A case of auricular flutter. Postgrad. M. J., Lond., 1935, 11: 191-4.— Herapath, C. E. K. Auricular flutter. Brit. M. J., 1928, 1: 213.— Herrmann, G. Auricular flutter. In Cyclop. Med. (Piersol- Bortz) Phila., 1939, 3: 867-9.—Holm, E. Ueber flatterndo Herzen. Acta ophth., Kbh., 1928, 6: 373-81.—Langeron, L. Cinq cas d'auricular flutter. J. sc. med. Lille, 1929, 47: pt 2, 125-32.—Laubry, C, & Van Bogaert, A. Sur quelques par- ticularit4s cliniques de la tachvsvstolie auriculaire (flutter). Bull. Soc. med. hop. Paris, 1932, 3. ser., 48: 426-30.—Marcellus, M. B. Auricular flutter. Med. Bull. Veterans Admin., 1935, 12: 59-61.—Marsh, F. B. Auricular flutter; a case report. South. M. & S., 1940, 102: 284-90.—Mathieu, L., & Simonin, J. Trois cas de flutter auriculaire. Rev. med. est, 1930, 58: 79-82.—Mohamed Ibrahim. A case of auricular flutter. J. Egypt. M. Ass., 1933, 16: 437.—Moore, H. Auricular flutter; a study of 5 cases. Lancet, Lond., 1928, 1: 795-801.—Muller, C. [A peculiar case of auricular flutter with general observa- tions on this condition] Norsk mag. lsegevid., 1930, 91: 402-13.—Mut, A. Qu6 debemos entender por taquisistolia auricular. Progr. clin., Madr., 1927, 35: 446-50.—Peco, G. Taquisistolfa auricular. Dfa med., B. Air., 1928-29, 1: 141.— Pruche, A. Le flutter et la fibrillation auriculaires. Bull. Soc med. Paris, 1934, 506-10.—Rachon, C, & Muszkatenblit, G. Flutter auriculaire. Arch. mal. coeur, 1935, 28: 651-61.— Raman, T. K. Auricular flutter. Ind. M. Gaz., 1940, 75: 732.—Schwab, E. H. Auricular flutter. Texas J. M., 1931-32, 27: 567-3. ---- Flutter: Associated disease. Gupta, J. C, & Sinha, A. C. A case of auricular flutter with a paroxysmal ventricular tachycardia showing reversion to a sinus rhythm. Calcutta M. J., 1937, 32: 299-307.—Kaufmann, R., & Rothberger, C. J. Der Uebergang von Kammerallo- rhythmien in Kammer-Arhythmie in kUnischen Fallen von Vorhofflattern, Alternans der Reizleitung. Zschr. ges. exp. Med., 1927, 57: 600-40, 4 ch.—Velasco Lombardini, R., & Aviles, M. C. La interferencia, el doble comando y los ritmos parciales; dos casos de flutter auricular parcial simultineos con el ritmo sinual que por momentos interfieren sus estimulos. Rev. argent, card., 1938-39, 5: 380-95. ---- Flutter: Diagnosis. Laubry, C, Routier, D., & Van Bogaert, A. Deux signes cliniques nouveaux de la tachycardie auriculaire (auricular flutter) Arch. mal. cceur, 1932, 25: 321-38.—Ludwig, H. Vorhofsflattern im Kymogramm. Rontgenpraxis, 1936, 8: 731-5.—Markovits. F. Vorhofflattern in dorsoventraler Ableitung. Zschr. Kreislaufforsch., 1935, 27: 193-6.—Mathieu, L., & Simonin, J. Les difficultes du diagnostic du flutter auriculaire. Rev. med. est, 1933, 61: 327-38. — Flutter: Etiology. See also subheading Fibrillation; Etiology; also Heart-block. Amberg, S., & Willius, F. A. Auricular flutter with con- genital heart disease. Am. J. Dis. Child., 1926, 32: 99-104.— Davis. H. Congenital isolated dextrocardia developing auric- ular flutter. Lancet, Lond., 1938, 1: 1331-3.—Kahn, M. H. Auricular flutter following direct injury ot the chest. Am. J. M. Sc, 1930, 179: 605-9, 2 pl.—Lian, C, & Viau, O. Auricular flutter et bradycardie par dissociation auriculo-ventriculaire complete. Arch. mal. cceur, 1930, 23: 514-7.—Liccioni, H. Caso de flutter auricular transitorio por intoxicaci6n digitiilica. Rev. Pohclfn. Caracas, 1941, 10: 192-201.—Oelker, D. L. Flutter fibrUlation in presence of avitaminosis; case report. Memphis M. J., 1941, 16: 151.—Vaghi, A. Flutter auricolare e polso epatico diastolico in un caso di vizio mitralico associate ad una probabile stenosi della tricuspide. Cuore & circol., 1933, 17: 508-13.—Warren, W. Auricular flutter during the treat- ment of auricular fibrillation by quinidine sulphate. S. Barth. Hosp. Rep., Lond., 1936. 69: 291-306 3 ol HEART AURICLE 233 HEART AURICLE ---- Flutter, juvenile. Calo, A. Deux cas de flutter auriculaire chez des nourrissons porteurs d'une cardiopathie congenitale. Arch. mal. cceur, 1939, 32: 978-94.—Carr, J. G., & McClure, W. B. Auricular flutter in a newly born infant; report of a case. Am. Heart J., 1931 6: 824-9.—Halbertsma, T., & Hartog, H. A. P. [On auricular flutter in a young child] Mschr. kindergeneesk., 1938- 39 8: 213-8, 3 pl. —---- Auricular flutter in a young infant with recovery on digitalis therapy. J. Pediat., S. Louis, 1939, 15-114-20. ------ [Case of atrial flutter of 2 J4 years duration in a child 4 years of age] Ned. tschr. geneesk., 1940, 84: 767- 9__Poynton, F. J.. & Wyllie, W. G. Auricular flutter in infancy. Lancet, Lond., 1926, 2: 371.—Sherman, J., & Schless, R A Auricular flutter in a newborn infant; case report. J. Pediat., S. Louis. 1934. 5: 802-10. ---- Flutter: Manifestation. Geraudel. Flutter et arythmie complete. Paris med., 1927, 63: 26-9. ------ Tachycardie paroxystique et flutter. Arch. mal. coeur, 1928, 21: 273-87.—Gino, G. Aritmia respiratoria da vibrazione auricolare. Bull. Accad. med. Roma, 1929, 55: 109-14.—Lian, C, & Blondel, A. Tachvcardies permanentes et reguUeres par flutter auriculaire (etude cUnique et eiectro- cardiographique) Hopital, 1930, 18: 253-5. ----— & Viau, O. Les tachycardies permanentes par flutter auriculaire. Bull. Soc. m6d. hop. Paris, 1929, 3. ser., 53: 1132-44.—Ludwig, H., & Bener, A. Horbarer Vorhofton bei Vorhofflattern. Klin. Wschr., 1936, 15: 271-3.—McMillan, T. M., & Bellet, S. Auricular flutter- some of its clinical manifestations and its treatment; based on a study of 65 cases. Am. J. M. Sc, 1932, 184: 33-57.—Taquini, A. Bruits auriculaires dans le flutter et dans la dissociation auriculo-ventriculaire. C. rend. Soc. biol., 1937, 126: 143-5. ---- Flutter: Pathogenesis, and physiopathol- ogy. Calo. A. Ascoltazione ed iscrizione dei toni atriaU in un caso di flutter auricolare. Cardiologia, Basel, 1939, 3: 203-12.— Friedberg, C. K., & Rothberger, C. J. Beitrag zur Kenntnis der Vorhof-Kammerleitung beim Vorhofflattern des Menschen. Zschr. klin. Med., 1932, 121: 14-49.—Gonzalo. G. R. Evolu- ci6n clfnica de la taquisistoUa auricular (flutter) Siglo med., 1927, 74: 377-9.—Hecht, H., & Johnston, F. D. Short parox- ysms of impure auricular flutter probably induced by normal sinus beats. Am. Heart J., 1940, 19: 237-42. Also repr — Hiatt. N., & Adams, L. Hyperactive carotid sinus mechanism in auricular flutter; a case report. Ann. Int. M., 1939-40, 13: 1489-500.—Kaufmann, R., & Rothberger, C. J. Ueber die unregelmassige Herztatigkeit bei Vorhofflattern. Klin. Wschr., 1927, 6: 381. ------& Kauf, E. Ueber die Entstehungsarten allorhythmischer Ventrikeltatigkeit bei Vorhofflattern. Zschr. ges. exp. Med., 1926, 52: 766-815.—Scherf, D. Versuche zur Theorie des Vorhofflatterns und Vorhofflimmerns. Ibid., 1928, 61: 30-44. ------ Zur Theorie des Vorhofflatterns und Vorhofflimmerns. Zschr. Kreislaufforsch., 1928, 20: 432-6 — White, P. D., & Stevens, H. W. Ventricular response to auricular premature beats and to auricular flutter. Arch. Int. M.. 1916, 18: 712-6. Also repr. ---- Flutter: Prognosis. Campbell, M., & Suzman, S. S. Auricular flutter with temporary reversion to normal rhythm after 6 years. Lancet, Lond., 1934, 2: 923.—Davis, N. S. A case of auricular flutter, converted to fibrillation and then to a normal rhythm with persistence of the rhvthm following a prostatectomy. Med. Clin. N. America, 1928, 12: 167-71.—Gager, L. T. Auricular flutter and complete heart block: with restoration of sinus rhythm and A-V conduction. Ann. Int. M., 1931, 5: 463-70.— Kossmann, C. E., & Berger, A. R. Auricular flutter of 11 years' duration with observations on esophageal electrocardiograms. Ibid., 1941-42, 15: 128-36.—Sprague, H. B.. & White, P. D. Auricular flutter; report of a case of 5 years' duration with spontaneous restoration of normal rhythm. J. Am. M. Ass., 1928, 90: 1772. ---- Flutter: Treatment. Bjerlov, H. [Quinidine treatment in auricular flutter] Sven. lak. tidn., 1931, 28: invart. med., 294-306.—Bloom, N., & Cashon, G. Effects of intravenous acetyl-beta-methyl- choline on paroxysmal auricular flutter. Virginia M. Month., 1937-38, 64: 341.—Carter, J. B., & Traut, E. F. Auricular flutter with 1:1 response successfully treated with quinidine. Proc. Inst. M. Chicago, 1934, 10: 270.—Constantinesco, C. D.. & Zamfir, C. Considerations sur le traitement de l'arythmie par flutter auriculaire. Bull. Acad. med. Roumanie, 1937, 3: 326-40.—Filip. L. [Two cases of auricular flutter cured by atypic therapy] Cas. 16k. desk., 1932. 71: 229.—Jezer, A., & Schwartz, S. P. Unusual manifestations following the use of quinidine sulphate in a patient with auricular flutter. Am. Heart J., 1934,10:124-7.—Langeron, L. Sur un cas d auricular flutter rebelle k toute th6rapeutique. Arch. mal. cceur, 1928, 21: 603-6.—Parkinson, J., & Bedford, D. E. The course and treatment of auricular flutter. Q. J. Med OxL, 1927-28, 21: 21-50, pl—Schwartz. G.. Taylor, B., & Metz, G. Digitalis in auricular flutter with idioventricular rhythm. Med. Rec, N. Y., 1941, 154: 461-3.—Wedd, A. M. Treatment nf „„,.•„ i flutter. . CUfton M. Bull., 1929-30Tl5:• wS^WjStoff^' Comparison of digitalis doses in auricular flutter on the auricle 23: 55M$ COnduotlon- Proc- Soc- ExP- Biol- N. Y., 1925?2o! ---- Flutter: Type. Allan, G. A. Case of paroxysmal auricular flutter with T-T ventricular response; effects of digitalis and auinidinp rlde af akut hjajrteblok. Ugeskr. laeger 1916, 78: 83-94.—Leyton. O. Case of heart- block. Proc R. Soc. M., Lond., 1922-23, 16: Sect. Clin., 35.— r,^oombacher« R- Troubles de conduction. Presse med., 1933 41: 1193.—McDonald, J. A. Heart-block. Tr. Indiana M. Soc, 1907, 58: 121-9—Mackenzie, J. Definition of the term heart-block. Brit. M. J., 1906, 2: 1107-11.—Martinez Alvarez, A. Clinicas medicas de los hospitales municipales- un caso de bl6queo del coraz6n. Bol. As. med. Puerto Rico, 1916-17, 13: 69.—Moore, S. A case of heart block. N. Zealand M. J., 1915, 14: 123-9.—Morrow, W. S. [Heart- block] Brit. M. J., 1906, 2: 1119.—Murray, R. S. E. Heart block. Med. Bull. Veterans Admin., 1933, 10: 120-3.— Mut, A. Un caso notable de heart-block. Rev. iber. amer. cienc med., 1911, 25: 110-4.—Ohm, R. Ein Fall von Herz- block. Zbl. Herzkrankh., 1918, 10: 129.—Penati, F. Su di un particolare caso di blocco cardiaco. Minerva med., Tor., 1931, 22: 17-30.—Preston, T. W. An unusual case of heart- block. Brit. M. J„ 1935, 1: 825.— Redelings, L. H. Heart block; report of a case. Tr. Ass. Physicians Mayo CUn. (1926) 1927, 7: 259-61, 2 pl.—Robinson, G. C. Presentation of a case of heart-block. J. Missouri M. Ass., 1914-15, 11: 243.— Rosenthal, S. R. Branch, arborization, and complete heart block. Arch. Int. M., 1932, 50: 730-58. Also repr.—Roth, I. R. Clinical types of heart block. Tr. Panamer. M. Congr. (1931) 1933, 3. Congr., 685-96.—Scherf, D. Leitungsstorungen im Herzen. Wien. klin. Wschr., 1928, 41: 375-80. Also Wien. med. Wschr., 1928, 78: 254.—Starling, H. J. Notes on a case of heart-block observed during a period of 13 years. Guy's Hosp. Rep., Lond., 1938, 88: 240-56.—Suzman, S. S. Case of heart block. Tr. M. Soc London, 1938, 61: 65.—Szczeklik, E. [Heart block] Polska gaz. lek., 1934, 13: 757.—Wencke- bach, K. F. Ueber Verkehrsstorungen im Herzen. Wien. med. Wschr., 1927, 77: 1307-11. Also Zschr. Bahnarzte, 1927, 22: 289-300.—Werley, G. A case of heart block. Southwest. M., 1919-20, 3: 10.—Whipham, T. R. Two cases of heart- block. Proc. R. Soc. M., Lond., 1914-15, 8: Sect. Stud. Dis. Child., 6-10.—Wolff, T. C. Heart block. Rhode Island M. J., 1929, 12: 85-93.—Zelenine, V. F. [Clinical types of cardiac block] Med. biol. J., Leningr., 1926, 2: No. 4-5, 5-37. Arborization block. See Heart-block, intraventricular; also Heart conduction, Purkinje fibers. ---- Asystole. See subheading Syncope; also Heart failure; Heart muscle, Contraction. ---- auricular. See also subheadings (Dissociation, interauricu- lar; intraauricular; sino-auricular) Benedict, A. L. Triple rhythm heart block with auricular interruption. N. York M. J., 1911, 94: 484.—Dominguez, C, & Bizzozero, R. C. Double commande auriculaire. Arch. mal. cceur, 1937, 30: 820-2.—Laufer. S. Ueber die Bedeutung der elektiven Ableitungen der Vorhofelektrogramme zum Nach- weis von Reizleitungsstorungen in den Vorhofen. Verh. Deut. Ges. Kreislaufforsch., 1935, 8: 212-9 [Discussion] 227. ------ & Rubino, A. Sull'importanza delle derivazioni elettive nella diagnosi dei disturbi di conduzione del miocardio atriale. Clin. med. ital., 1936, 67: 365-81.—Rasario, G. M. Con- tributo alia conoscenza delle turbe di conduzione del mio- cardio atriale. Ibid., 1938, 69: 511-9, pl—Scherf, D., & Shookhoff, C. Ueber Leitungsstorungen im Vorhofe. Zschr. ges. exp. Med., 1926, 49: 302-26.—Snellen, H. A. Ueber Leitungsstorungen in den Vorhofen. Zschr. Kreislaufforsch., 1936, 28: 234-8. ---- auriculo-ventricular. See also subheading Dissociation, auriculo- ventricular; also Heart neurosis; Heart rheuma- tism, &c. Almeida Prado, A. de. Bradycardia por perturbacao complexa do feixe de His; multiplicidade de rhythmos; formas de passagem entre o rhythmo sinusal, bloqueio parcial auricu- loventricular e bloqueio completo e entre os bloqueios parcial e total de ramo. In his Lie. conf. clin. med., S. Paulo, 1934, 75-97.—Andersen, W. T. [Characteristic cases of atrio- ventricular block] Hospitalstidende, 1935, 78: 524-29.— Belski, A. Ueber die an der A-V-Grenze blockirten Systolen. HEART-BLOCK 240 HEART-BLOCK Zschr. klin. Med., 1901, 44: 179-81.—Bullrich, R. A., & Braun Men£ndez, K. Un caso de bloqueo aurlculoventricular con r-omplejos ventriculares de forma variable. Rev. argent, card., 1934-35, 1: 64-75/—Castex, M. R., Lopez Ramirez, R., & Pittaluga Noguera. Interferencia transitoria de dos ritmos. mihimiI \ nodal, provocado por adrenalina en un caso de bloqueo A-V parcial. Rev. Soc. med. int.. B. Air., 1928, 4: 339-46.— Clerc. A., & L£vy, R. Sur l'auricular flutter; associe au bjoc auriculoventriculaire. In Libro de oro (M. R. Castex) B. Air., 1938, 2: 243-53.—Dana, H. W., & Dameshek, W. Inter- mittent auricular ventricular block. Am. J. M. Sc, 1926, 171: 485-9, ch.—Deneke, T. Die Ueberleitungsstorungen zwischen Vorhof und Kammer des HerzeiLs. Mitt. Hamburg. Staats- krankenanst., 1907, 7: 167-90. Also Miinch. med. Wschr., 1907, 54: 1101.—Geraudel, E. I.c block sino-diverticulaire. Ann. med., Par., 1931, 30: 31-44. ------ Etude d'un cas de tachycardie avec association auriculo-ventriculaire. Arch. mal. coeur, 1937, 30: 796-804.—Mentzingen, A. von. Ueber einen Fall von wechselnder peripherer Leitungsstorung des Herzens mit wechselnder Form der Kammerkomplexe. Zschr. Kreislaufforsch., 1933, 25: 337-44.—Moia, B., & Schiavi, A. C. Bloqueo total auriculo-ventricular con restablecimiento del ritmo sinusal despues de 4 meses de evoluci6n. Rev. argent. card., 1935-36, 2: 196-200.—Petersen, O. V. C. E. Det atrioventrikulaere heart-block. Ugeskr. lteger, 1913, 75: 1183-90.—Vaerneus, A. [Case of transitory, atrioventricular , block] Sven. lak. tidn., 1932, 29: [Sven. foren. inv. med. forh.] 82-4.—Yater, W. M. Auriculoventricular heart block. Mod. Concepts Card. Dis., 1935, 4: No. 10, 1.—Zarday. I. Unge- wohnliche Vorbofkammerleitung. Zschr. Kreislaufforsch., 1937, 29: 208-15. ---- auriculo-ventricular, complete. See subheading Dissociation, auriculo-ventri- cular. ---- auriculo-ventricular: Etiology and patho- genesis. Belot, E. J. *Les alterations des connexions auriculo-ventriculaires au cours des maladies infectieuses; dissociation complete et incomplete. 103p. 8? Pur., 1938. Barrier, C. W., & Stout, S. E. Atrioventricular heart block, its etiology, prognosis and treatment. Texas J. M., 1933, 28: 675-78.—Bonniger, M. Ueber einige Falle von gestorter Leitung zwischen Atrium und Ventrikel beim kranken mensch- lichen Herzen. Zschr. exp. Path. Ther., 1905, 1: 663-9, 2 diagr.—Bogaert, A. van. Chnmaxie et troubles de la conduc- tion auriculo-ventriculaire. Arch. mal. cceur, 1933, 26: 108-39.—Braun-Menendez, E.. & Solan, L. A. Etude des bruits auriculaires dans le bloc auriculo-ventriculaire experi- mental. C. rend. Soc. biol., 1936. 123: 502-4.—Calabresi, M. Osservazioni e considerazioni sui disturbi di conduzione atrio- ventricolari. Clin. med. ital., 1932, 63: 27-58, 5 ch.—Dagnini, G. Bradicardia ventricolare permanente con accessi di tachi- sistolia auricolare; ritorno transitorio al ritmo normale; ancora sulla dottrina del doppia comando. Bull. sc. med., Bologna, 1935, 107: 257-61, pl.—Jourdan, F., & Froment, R. Etude eiectrocardiographique du bloc auriculo-ventriculaire obtenu par ecrasement du faisceau de His. C. rend. Soc. biol., 1939, 131: 286-8.—Lauf, E. Ueber Aetiologie, Prognose und Thera- pie des atrio-ventrikularen Blocks. Klin. Wschr., 1937, 16: 303-6.—Meyer, P. Troubles fonctionnels de la conductibilite auriculo-ventriculaire chez un sportif. Arch. mal. cceur, 1925, 18: 772-5.—Rasario, G. M. Studio sui blocchi cardiaci; ricerche elettrocardiografiche su alcuni casi non comuni di blocco atrio-ventricolare. Fol. med., Nap., 1938, 24: 703-25, 4 tab.—Shookhoff, C, & Blumenfeld, L. Transient functional A-V heart block induced by the swallowing of food; case report. Ann. Int. M., 1939-10, 13: 345-51.—Yater, W. M., Cornell, V. H., & Claytor, T. Auriculoventricular heart block due to bilateral bundle-branch lesions; review of the Uterature and report of 3 cases with detailed histopathologic studies. Arch Int. M., 1936, 57: 132-73. Also repr. ---- auriculo-ventricular: Manifestation. See also subheading (Rhythm; Syncope, &c.) also Heart rate. Gallavardin, L., & Veil, P. Sur un cas de bradycardie permanente k 40; rythme nodal avec P positif ou dereglage auriculo-ventriculaire. Arch. mal. cceur, 1928, 21: 210-3, ch.— Norr, J. Anhaltende Bradykardie durch Atrioventrikular- rhythmus mit Atmungsarrhythmie beim Silberfuchs. Verh. Deut. Ges. Kreislaufforsch., 1933, 6: 106-15 [Discussion] 145.—Paniefiski, Die Ueberleitungsstorungen und der Adams- Stokes'sche Symptomenkomplex (mit Beriicksichti- gung ihrer Beziehung zum Atrioventrikularbundel) Zschr. iirztl. FortbUd., 1912, 9: 75-80.—Rasario, G. M. Fibrillazione auricolare e blocco atrio-ventricolare. Cuore & circol., 1939 23: 398-406, ch. ---- auriculo-ventricular, partial or incomplete. Andersen, W. T. Delayed auriculoventricular conduction. Acta med. scand., 1936, Suppl. 78, 308-14.—Ashman, R. Evidence against the latency theory of partial A-V block. Proc Soc. Exp. Biol., N. Y., 1929-30, 27: 82.—Buchem, F. S. P. van [Explanation of partial atrioventricular heart- block) Ned. tschr. geneesk., 1929, 73: 911-31, pl.— Doumer, E. Dissociation auriculo-ventriculaire incomplete de rythme 2/1 avec anticipation de l'onde auriculaire bloquee. Arch. mal. coeur, 1933, 26: 172-84.- Edens, E. Ueber den Herz- block vom Typus II. Klin. Wschr., 1935, 14: 1669.—Froment. R., Masson, R., & Gonin, A. Defaut de subordination ventricu- laire dans les blocks A-V partiels ou frustes; aspects et signi- fication. Arch. mal. cceur, 1939, 32: 849-59.—Gonzalez Sabathie, L. La auscultaci6n en el bloqueo parcial auriculo- ventricular. In his Tenuis cardiol., B. Air., 1939, 2: 97-104.— Gross, D. Elektrischer Vorhofsalternans und partieller Vor- hofkammer-block. Zschr. Kreislaufforsch., 1941, 33: 24-8.— Mattioli, M. Studio elettrocardiografico sull'azione di varic sostanze in un caso di blocco cardiaco incompleto 3:1. Cuore & circol., 1937, 21: 453-62, 3 pl.—Mobitz. Ueber den partiellen Vorhof-Kammerblock am menschlichen Herzen. Klin. Wschr., 1927, 6: 828.—Sa, A. Ritmo a tres tiempos en un bloqueo parcial auriculo-ventricular. Dfa med., B. Air., 1935, 7: 1481-3.—Spangenberg, J. J., Vedoya, R., & Gonzalez Videla, J. Un signo auscultatorio de los bloqueos auriculo-ventriculares parciales con perfodos de Luciani-Wenckebach; aparici6n de un tercer ruido cuya intensidad varfa ciclicamente; estudio fonocardiogrdfico. Rev. argent, card., 1937-38, 4: 20-7.— Spreng, L. Ueber einen Fall von voriibergehender Reizleitungs- storung (Partieller a-v-Block) Deut. med. Wschr., 1935, 61: 209-11. ---- auriculo-ventricular: Treatment. Arrillaga, F. C. La adrenalina en las disociaciones auriculo- ventriculares; constataciones electrocardiogr&ficas. Prensa med. argent., 1917-18, 4: 365.—Danielopolu, D., & Danulescu, V. Action de 1'adrenaline dans la dissociation auriculo- ventriculaire incomplete. C. rend. Soc. biol., 1916, 79:105-7.— Fogelson, L. I., & Kabakov, I. B. [Adrenalin in atrio-ventricu- lar block] Ter. arkh., 1934, 12: 133-9.—Hardoy, P. J., & Houssay, B. A. Acci6n de la adrenalina en la disociaci6n auriculo-ventricular. Rev. As. med. argent., 1917, 27: 462- 71.—Kienle, F. Die naturheilerische Behandlung atrio- ventrikularer Leitungsstorungen; gleichzeitig ein Beitrag zur Frage der Leistungsfahigkeit des Belastungselektrokardio gramma. Deut. med. Wschr., 1940, 66: 651-3. ---- bundle branch. See also Heart-block, intraventricular; Heart conduction, Bundle of His-Tawara. Stelle, A. *Zur Klinik des menschlichen Schenkeiblocks [Halle-Wittenberg] 12p. 21cm. Eisleben, 1936. Archer, J. G. Some observations on cases of bundle branch block. Mississippi Doctor, 1940-41, 18: 211-5.—Bishop, L. F. Cardiological and cUnical considerations of bundle-branch block. Internat. CUn., 1926, 36. ser., 4: 177-94, 17 pl.—Boyer, N. H. Paroxysmal bundle branch block converted into two-to-one bundle branch block by means of atropine. Am. Heart J., 1939, 18: 115-9.—Bullrich, R. A. Bloqueo sino-auricular. Rev. med. lat. amer., B. Air., 1928, 14: 3197-208.—Castex, R. M., Lopez Ramirez, R., & Battro, A. Bloqueos de rama concordante. Dfa med., B. Air., 1930-31, 3: 411-3. Also Prensa med. argent., 1930-31, 17: 849-59.—Coelho, E. Blo- queio isolado dos ramos e das terminac5es do feixe de His. Lisboa med., 1928, 5: 638-66.—Dry, T. J., & Willius, F. A. Cardiac clinics; disturbances of ventricular conduction. Proc. Mayo Clin., 1941, 16: 154-7.—Graybiel, A., & Sprague, H. B. Bundle branch block; an analysis of 395 cases. Am. J. M. Sc, 1933, 185: 395-401, 3 pl.—Hill, H. E. Bundle-branch heart- block; report of case. U. S. Nav. M. BuU., 1926, 24: 77-82, 2 ch.—Homan, R. H. Bundle branch block; review of cases. Southwest. M., 1940, 24: 1-3.—King, J. T. Bundle-branch block. Internat. CUn., 1931, 41. ser., 3: 69-75. Also In Barker Festschrift, 1932, 69-75.—Lafuente, Duque & Lopez Morales. Nuestra experiencia scbre bloqueos de ramas del fascfculo de His. Med. ibera, 1934, 28: 863.—Mallardo, C. A. I blocchi di branca. Morgagni, 1931, 73: 894-902.—Oppen- heimer, E T., & Oppenheimer, B. S. Right and left bundle branch block in the human heart. Sunti Congr. internaz. fisiol., 1932. 14. Congr., 198.—Pescador, L. Bloqueos de rama del fascfculo de His. Arch, med., Madr., 1931, 34: 96-105 — Petersen, O. V. C. E.. & Hall, H. C. Et tilfasde af bradycardi med forandringer i His—Tawara's bundt. Hospitalstidende, 1912, 5. R., 5: 881-9, 3 pl.—Pires Salgado. Bloqueio dos ramos do feixe de His. BrasU med., 1937, 51: 392; 517.—Sampson, J. J. Bundle branch block. Mod. Concepts Card. Dis., 1938, 7: r,?-' 1?,'r 1;—Scnerf' D- Reizleitungsstbrungen im Schenkel. Khn. Wschr., 1925, 4: 2207. ------ Reizleitungsstorungen im Bundel. Wien. Arch. inn. Med., 1926, 12: 327-52, 3 pl. —---- & Shookhoff. Ueber Leitungsstorungen im Bundel. Wien. kUn. Wschr., 1925, 38: 263.—Smith, A. L. Review of 47 cases of one sided branch block. Nebraska M. J., 1932, 17: 179-85— Talley, J. E., & Reed, O. K. A study of 28 cases of bundle-branch block. Am. Heart J., 1925-26, 1: 262-8.— Wesson, H. R., & Walters, W. Two cases cf bundle-branch block with associated choleUthiasis and a case of alkalosis in which operations were performed. Proc. Mayo Clin. 1937, HEART-BLOCK 241 HEART-BLOCK ---- bundle branch, alternating. Chrzanowski, J., & Stiller, A. [Two cases of alternating block of the left and right divisions of the bundle of His] Warsz. czas. lek., 1936, 13: 689-92.—Sloer, M. Sindrome de Stokes-Adams con bloqueo alternante de ramas. Acci6n med., B. Air., 1939, 9:407-9. ---- bundle branch: Diagnosis. Battro, A., Braun-Menendez, E., & Orias, O. Asincronismo de la contraction ventricular en el bloqueo de rama; su de- mostraci6n mediante el registro optico de los fen6menos me- c&nicos de la actividad cardfaca. Rev. argent, card., 1936-37, 3: 325-59.—Camauer, A., & Sacon, J. Bloqueo de rama de haz de His, con paroxismos de pulso lento y estado de mal epilepti- forme. Prensa med. argent., 1936, 23: 2275-7.—Cossio, P., & Gil Yepez, C. El desdoblamiento del segundo ruido en el diag- n6stico clinico del bloqueo de rama. Rev. argent, card., 1940- 41, 7: 199; 1941-42, 8: [Discussion] 63-5.—Freund, H. A., & Sokolov, R. Bundle branch block; criteria of classification, diagnosis and prognosis; a study of 210 cases, with foUow-up data. Arch. Int. M., 1939, 63: 319-33.—Granger. A. S. The cUnical significance of bundle branch lesions. CaUfornia West. M., 1926, 24: 626-8.—Gray, J. A. C. Bundle branch block, diagnosis by physical signs. N. York State J. M., 1937, 37: 169-73.—Herles, F., Lukl, P. [et al.] Zur Frage der LokaUsa- tion des Schenkelblocks. Cardiologia, Basel, 1938, 2: 1-46.— King, J. T. The cUnical recognition and phvsical signs of bundle-branch block. Am. Heart J., 1927-28, 3: 505-24. -----& McEachern, D. The nature of the physical signs of bundle-branch block. Tr. Ass. Am. Physicians, 1931, 46: 39-51. Also Am. J. M. Sc, 1932, 183: 445-55, 4 pl.—Lewis, J. K. Nature and significance of heart sounds and of apex impulses in bundle branch block. Arch. Int. M., 1934, 53: 741-61.—Lian, C, & Golblin, V. Le diagnostic de la locaUsa- tion droite ou gauche du block des branches; bloc septo-ventricu- laire. Arch. mal. cceur, 1937, 30: 787-95.—Mohler, K. H. Bundle-branch block; its diagnosis and relation to other cardiac disturbances. Med. CUn. N. America, 1930-31, 14: 885-96.— Peco, G., & Montoreano, F. Bloqueos de rama; criterio actual. Sem. med., B. Air., 1940. 47: pt 2, 1465-9.—Rothberger, C. J. Zur Diagnose des Schenkelblocks. Zschr. klin. Med., 1933, 123: 460-89. ------& Goebel, F. [Diagnosis of heart-block after injury to the branches of the auriculo-ventricular system] Lek. wojsk., 1934, 23: 67; 127.—Wolferth, C. C, & Margolies, A. Asynchronism in contraction of the ventricles in the so- caUed common type of bundle-branch block: its bearing on the determination of the side of the significant lesion and on the mechanism of spUt first and second heart sounds. Am. Heart J., 1934-35, 10:425-52.------& Bellet, S. The side of the significant lesion in the common type of bundle-branch block. Tr. Ass. Am. Phys., 1933, 48: 187-94. ---- bundle branch: Electrocardiography. Alfredson, B. V., & Sykes, J. F. Studies on bovine electro- cardiogram; bundle branch blcck. Proc. Soc Exp. Biol., N. Y., 1940, 43: 580-4.—Bain. C. W. C. Variable ventricular complexes in heart block, and their relation to bUateral bundle branch block. Brit. Heart J., 1941, 3: 75-92.—Boyd, L. J., & Scherf, D. Bundle-branch block and the monophasic electro- cardiogram. Proc Soc. Exp. Biol., N. Y., 1939, 42: 364-8.— Castex, M. R., & Lopez Ramirez, R. Alternancia eiectrica por bloqueo de rama. Rev. argent, card. 1934^35, 1: 55-63.— Chini, V. Appunti di elettrocardiologia, sulla contemporaneity, di blocchi multipU deUo stimolo cardiaco lungo il decorso del fascio primitivo. Cuore & circol., 1927, 11: 221-8.—Ershler, I. L., Stringer, S., & Robb, J. S. Modification of R in chest leads foUowing acute and chronic muscle bundle lesions. Am. J. Physiol., 1941, 133: 269.—Fischer, R. Influence d'une thrombose coronarienne aigue sur l'eiectrocardiogramme d'un bloc de branches. Arch. mal. coeur, 1938, 31: 997-1009 — Foster, P. C. The relation of the position of the heart to the initial ventricular deflections in experimental bundle-branch block. Am. Heart J., 1934-35, 10: 1042-6.—Hartog, H. A. P. [Bundle-branch-block with shortened P-R deflections] Ned. tschr. geneesk., 1940, 84: 665.—Kissin, M., Ackerman, W., & Katz, L. N. The effect of the heart's position on the electro- cardiographic appearance of bundle-branch block in man. Am. J. M. Sc, 1933, 186: 721-3, pl.—Mallardo, C. A. Le preponderanze ventricolari da blocchi di branca. Morgagni, 1933, 75:451-60, 3 diagr.—Mann, H. Interpretation of bundle- branch block by means of the monocardiogram. Am. Heart J., 1930-31, 6: 447-57.—Nichol, A. D. The interpretation of lead inversion in bundle-branch block. Ibid., 1933, 9: 72-80.— Pomodoro, I. G. Ricerche elettro-cardiografiche sul blocco di branca. Cuore & circol., 1930, 14: 316-31.—Pratsicas, A. De la valeur de l'eiectrocardiographie dans le diagnostic et le pronostic des maladies du cceur (le block des branches du fais- ceau de His) Arch. mal. cceur, 1936, 29: 455-85.—Roberts, G. H., & Abramson, D. I. Ventricular complexes of the bundle- branch-block type associated with short P-R intervals. Ann. Int. M., 1935-36, 9: 983-7.—Stefanutti, P. Alternanza elet- trica successiva a blocco di branca intermittente. Cuore & circoL, 1940, 24: 202-9.—Steinmann, B. Beitrag zur Kenntnis des Schenkelblockelektrokardiogramms. Zschr. Kreislauf- forsch., 1941, 33: 345-70.—Tung, C. L., & Cheer, S. N. A correlation of cUnical and electro-cardiographic findings in human bundle branch block. China M. J., 1933, 47: 15-28.— Weinstein, J., & Abramson, D. I. LocaUzation of the site of 227475—vol. 7, 4th seeies---16 experimental premature contractions and bundle branch lesions by means of multiplane chest leads. Ann. Int. M., 1935-36 9- 1187-95.—Willius, F. A. Clinical features of cases exhibiting electro-cardiograms conforming to those cf experimental com- plete bundle-branch block. Am. Heart J., 1925-26, 1: 576- 93.—Wilson, F. N. Form of the electrocardiogram; bundle- branch block. In Cyclop. Med. (Piersol-Bortz) PhUa., 1939 3: 813-6. ---- Bundle branch, incomplete or atypical. Battro, A., Braun-Menendez, E., & Orias, O. L'asyn- chronisme ventriculaire dans les blocs de branche; sa de- monstration au moyen de 1'enregistrement des phenomenes mecaniques de l'activite cardiaque. Arch. mal. cceur. 1938, 31: 250-61.—Bishop, L. F., jr, & Carden, G. A., jr. The prognosis of bundle branch block. Am. Heart J., 1939, 17: 275-85.— Vond, G. S., & Campbell, C. S. Prognosis in bundle branch block. J. Indiana M. Ass., 1938, 31: 440.—Braun-Menendez, E., & Solari, L. A. Ventricular asynchronism in bundle branch block. Arch. Int. M., 1939, 63: 830-47. Also repr.—Comeau, W. J., Hamilton, J. G. M., & White, P. D. Paroxysmal bundle- branch block associated with heart disease. Am. Heart J 1938, 15: 276-316.—Ewert, B. Ein FaU mit partieUem Schen- kelblock, der unter dem elektrckardiographischen BUd eines Verzweigungsblockes verUef. Cardiologia, Basel, 1939, 3: 182-93.—Faulkner, J. M. Transient bundle-branch block. Med. CUn. N. America, 1932, 15: 997-1003.—Hermann, G., & Ashman, R. Partial bundle-branch block: a theoretical con- sideration of transient normal intra-ventricular conduction in the presence of apparently complete bundle-branch block. Am. Heart J., 1930-31, 6: 375-403.—Isaacson, I. Atypical bundle-branch block with normal P-R. interval in a healthy young man. S. Afr. M. J., 1938, 12: 885-7.—Katz, L. N., Hamburger, W. W., & Rubinfeld, S. H. Partial bundle-branch block. Am. Heart J., 1932, 7: 753-6.—Mahaim, I. Con- siderations anatomiques sur le bloc de branches. Arch. mal. cceur, 1938, 31: 436-41.—Pick, A. Beitrag zur Frage des atypischen Schenkelblocks. Zschr. kUn. Med., 1935-36, 129: 719-32.—Pines, I. Ein FaU von funktioneUem Schenkelblock wahrend der Schwangerschaft. Wien. Arch. inn. Med., 1938, 32: 129-50.— Rud, E. Untersuchungen uber Schenkelblock. Acta med. scand., 1938, 97: 265-92.—Slater, S. R. Partial bundle-branch block; a case of three-to-one and four-to-one block. Am. Heart J., 1929-30, 5: 617-34.—Stenstrom, N. Further experience on incomplete bundle branch block in man. Acta med. scand., 1927, 67: 353-84, 3 ch.—Von Deesten, H. T., & Dolganos, M. Atypical bundle-branch block with a favor- able prognosis. Am. J. M. Sc, 1934, 188: 231-5.—Willius, F. A., & Keith, N. M. Intermittent incomplete bundle-branch block. Am. Heart J., 1926-27, 2: 255-65. ---- bundle branch: Left branch type. Bishop, L. F. Transient, recurrent, complete left bundle- branch block. Am. Heart J., 1938, 15: 354-7. Also repr.— Braun-Menendez, E., & Solari, L. A. Asynchronisme ventricu- laire par section des branches du faisceau de His; section de la branche gauche. C. rend. Soc biol., 1937, 125: 531-3. Also Rev. Soc. argent, biol., 1937, 13: 33-42.— Braunstein, A. L., Bass, J. B., & Thomas, S. Gummatous myocarditis and aneurysm of the left ventricle with nodal tachycardia, and, subsequently, bundle branch block; report of case. Am. Heart J., 1940, 19: 613-22.— Duque, A., Lopez Morales, J., & La- fuente, A. Bloqueo de la rama izquierda del fasciculo de His. Arch, med., Madr., 1933, 36: 110-3.—Mahaim. I. NouveUes recherches sur les lesions du faisceau de His-Tawara; le bloc de branche gauche et sa pathogenie; la septite mitrale. Ann. med., Par., 1935, 38: 185-211.—Nisse, B. S. Congenital heart disease associated with arborization block of the left branch bundle. Proc R. Soc. M., Lond., 1928-29, 22: Sect. CUn., 27.—Porto, J. Lesion de la branche gauche du faisceau de His et image eiectrocardiographique du bloc de branche droite (conception classique) Arch. mal. cceur, 1938, 31: 330-8. ---- bundle branch: Pathogenesis. Benaros, M. EI concepto de evoluci6n en las lesiones del haz de His y de la rama derecha. Prensa med. argent., 1934—35, 21: 1094-111.— Blackford, L. M., & Parker, F. P. Pulmonary stenosis with bundle branch block; report of a case with sound tracings and semiserial studies of the conduction bundle. Arch. Int. M., 1941, 67: 1107-18.—Bohnengel, C. Paroxysmal bundle branch block associated with physiologic changes in a patient with organic heart disease; report of case. Am. Heart J., 1938, 16: 587-94.—Calo, A. Tetrade de FaUot en anomalies electrocardiographiques complexes et instables (rythme septal, block de branche et alternance ventriculaire) Arch. mal. coeur, 1937, 30: 805-19.—Carr, F. B. Functional bundle branch block. N. England J. M., 1933, 209: 1101-4.—Doria, R. Sulla claudicatio del fascio di His e sul fenomeno di Zeri. Cuore & circol., 1928, 12: 565-73.—Durant, T. M., Ginsburg, I. W., & Roesler, H. Transient bundle branch block and other electrocardiographic changes in pulmonary embolism. Am. Heart J., 1939, 17: 423-30.—Hill, I. G. W. Bundle branch block; a cUnical and histological study. Q. J. Med., Oxf., 1930-31, 24: 15-28, 3 pl. ------ The effect of ligation of posterior coronary vessels on the electro-cardiogram in experi- mental bundle-branch block. J. Physiol., Lond., 1934, 81: 70- 80.—Hyman, A. S., & Parsonnet, A. E. Bundle branch block; the phenomenon of its development in relation to axis deviation HEART-BLOCK 242 HEART-BLOCK of the heart. Arch. Int. M., 1930, 45: 868-78. Also ropr.— Mahaim, I. De l'anatomie pathologique des bloc de branches, aver un nouvrrni cas. Ann. med., Par., 192,\ 22: 3S1-406.— Master. A. M.. Dack. S., & Jaffe, H. L. Bundle branch and intraventricular block in acute roronarv artery occlusion. Am. Heart J., 1938, 16: 2S3-308- Master. A. M., Kalter, H. [et al.] The relation between bundle branch block and cardiac enlarge- ment. Ibid., 1940, 20: 186-94. Also repr.—Mortensen, V. Pathogenesis of bundle branch block and other prepon- derance curves; on false and true infarction curves in pre- cordial leads. Acta med. scand., 1940, 104: 267-90. Also Nord. med., 1939, 2: 1971-80.—Newman, M. Bundle-branch block of vagal origin. Brit. M. J., 1931, 2: 1134.—Pines, I. [Mechanism of the functional block of the branch of His' bundle] Warsz. czas. lek., 1937, 14: 795.—Purks. W. K. Further evidence in regard to functional bundle-branch block. Ann. Int. M., 1938-39, 12: 1105-12.—Ramos, J. Complete auriculo-ventricular heart block associated with auricular flutter caused by a lesion of the 2 branches of the bundle of His. Rev. biol., S. Paulo, 1932, 3: 68-79, 2 pl.—Roberts, G. H., Crawford, J. H. [et al.] Experimental bundle-branch block in the cat. Am. Heart J., 1932, 7: 505-13.— Roberts, G. IL, Crawford, J. H., & Abramson, D. I. Experimental bundle branch block in the monkey. J. CUn. Invest., 1935, 14: 867- 70.—Sigler, L. H. Functional bundle-branch block (partial) paradoxically relieved by vagal stimulation. Am. J. M. Sc, 1933, 185: 211-9.—Soliterman, M. L. [Pathogenesis of func- tional intermittent, intraventricular heart block (block of the branches of the bundle of His)] Klin, med., Moskva, 1940, 18: No. 7, 117-21.—Taussig, H. B. A case of bundle branch block confirmed bv pathological study. Bull. Johns Hopkins Hosp., 1929, 45:40-55.—Tung, C. L. Functional bundle-branch block. Am. Heart J., 1936, 11: 89-98.—Van der Kloot, A. Congenital bundle branch block as a result, probably, of a defect in the interventricular septum; report of a case. Ibid., 1940, 19: 623-5.—Veil, P. Le gros cceur aitiu avec dissociation inter- ventriculaire. Arch. mal. coeur, 1938, 31: 262-70.—Vesell, H. Critical rates in ventricular conduction; unstable bundle branch block. Am. J. M. Sc, 1941, 202: 198-207.—Yater, W. M. Pathogenesis of bundle branch block; review of the litera- ture; report of 16 cases with necropsy and of 6 cases with de- tailed histologic study of the conduction system. Arch. Int. M., 1938, 62: 1-96. Also Med. Ann. District of Columbia, 1938, 7: 10; 54. ---- bundle branch: Physiopathology. Baader, E., Marzahn, H., & Zaeper, G. Ueber die Leistungs- fiihigkeit des Herzens bei funktioiiellem Schenkelblock. Klin. Wschr., 1936, 15: 1259-01.—Baker, B. M., jr. The effect of cardinc rate and the inhalation of oxvgen on transient bundle branch block. Arch. Int. M., 1930, 45: 814-22. Also repr.— Castellano, T. Fisiopatologfa de los bloqueos de rama o intra- ventriculares. Prensa med. argent., 1936, 23: 2143-57.— Fredericq, L. Acceleration du pouls arteriel par l'exercice musculaire dans le cas de lesion du faisceau de His. C. rend. Soc. biol., 1912, 72: 810-2.—Katz, L. N., Landt, H., & Bohning, A. The delay in the onset of ejection of the left ventricle in bundle-branch block. Am. Heart J., 1934-35, 10: 681-92.— Wilson, R. N., Macleod, A. G., & Barker, P. S. The order of ventricular excitation in human bundle-branch block. Ibid., 1932, 7:305-30 ---- bundle branch: Prognosis. Bagnaresi, G. U blocco di branca instabile. Cuore & circol., 1934, 18: 65-82.—Bishop, L. F., & Bishop, L. F., jr. Bundle branch block of unusual duration. J. Am. M. Ass., 1932, 98: 398. Also Med. Rec, N. Y., 1937, 145: 10.—Eidlow, S. Transient recurrent bundle-branch block. Canad. M. Ass. J., 1937, 37: 240-3.—Jennings, A. F., & Johnson, R. A. Length of Ufe of cardiac cases, including 5 cases of bundle branch block. Internat. Clin., 1938, n. ser., 4: 123-34, 3 pl.—Kapff, W. von. Ueber einen Fall von passagerem Schenkelblock. KUn. Wschr., 1928, 7: 357.—King, J. T. Bundle-branch block: a case analysis with especial reference to incidence and prognosis. Tr. Ass Am. Phys., 1933, 48: 164-86. Also Am. J. M. Sc, 1934, 187: 149-71.—Kurtz, C. M. Transient complete bundle-branch block; report of 6 cases. Am. Heart J., 1936, 11: 212-22.— Lopez Ramirez, R., & Baila, M. R. El pronostico de los bloqueos de rama. Dfa med., B. Air., 1940, 12: 482. Also Rev. med., B. Air., 1940, 2: 251-7.—Massee, J. C. Transitory bundle branch block and nodal rhythm. J. M. Ass. Georgia 1939, 28: 105-8.—Miller, H., & Fulton, F. T. Transient, re- current bundle-branch block. N. England J. M., 1939, 221: 291-6.—Morris, R. S., & McGuire, J. Transient complete bundle-branch block. Am. J. M. Sc, 1932, 184: 202-5.— Puddu, V., & Sihilia, D. Quattro casi di blocco di branca transitorio. Boll. Acad. med. Roma, 1939, 65: 5-8.—Rasario, G. M. Sui blocchi di branca instabili. Cuore & circol., 1940* 24: 139-61, pl—Reeser, R., jr, Willius, F. A., & Dry, T. j! Life expectancy in conductive disturbances affecting the ventricular complex of the electrocardiogram; special considera- tion of bundle branch block with concordant graphs and with discordant graphs. Arch. Int. M., 1941, 67: 1027-33.— Strauss, L. H., & Bolt, F. Ueber die Bedeutung des typischen und atypischen Schenkelblockes fur die Begutachtung und Beurteilung der Arbeitsfahigkeit. Zschr. klin. Med., 1939, 136: 560-76.—Szekely, G. [Recovery from block of the Tawara branch] Orv. hetil., 1935, 79: 615. Also Wien. klin Wschr., 1935, 48: 896-8.- Willius, F. A., Dry. T. J., & Resser, R., jr. Life expectancy in conductive disturbances alTecting the ventricular complex of the electrociirdiogram; general considerations of bundle branch block with concordant and with discordant graphs and the wide S wave pattern, based on 1,611 cases. Arch. Int. M., 1941, 67: 1008-26. ---- bundle branch: Right branch type [includ- ing Mahaim's syndrome] Ackerman, W., & Katz, L. N. Reversal in direction of the QRS complex of experimental right bundle-branch block with change in the heart's position. Am. Heart J., 1933, 8: 490-5. - Agostini, G. Un cas de lesion de la branche droite du faisn-au de His soupconnee cUniquement; diagnostique par leleotro- cardiogramme et controiee k l'autopsie. Arch. mal. c.u-ur 1929, 22: 577-S7. Also Atti Soc. lombard. sc. med., 1929, \h\ 97-102.—Bach, K. The clinical significance of right branch bundle block. (I J. Med., Oxf., 1929-30, 23: 261-72, pl.— Bayley, R. H. The frequency and significance of right bundle- branch block. Am. J. M. Sc, 1934, 188: 236-42.—Braun- Menendez, E., & Solari, L. A. Asincronismb ventricular por section de las ramas del haz de His; secci6n de la rama derecha Rev. Soc. argent, biol., 1936, 12: 331-49. Also C. rend. Soc' biol., 1937, 124: 251-4.—Bungartz, T., & Dressen, H. Ueber die Bedeutung der Elektrokardiographie fiir die Diagnostik kindlicher Herzerkrankungen; Aortenstenose mit rechtsseitigem Schenkelblock. Mschr. Kinderh., 1928, 38: 202-9.—Campbell, S. B. B., & Turkington, S. I. Right bundle-branch block; an' analysis of the clinical records of 56 cases with typical electro- cardiograms. Q. J. Med., Oxf., 1931, 24: 481-5, 2 pl.— Cotrim, N. Aspecto electrocardiografico atipico, no bloqueio de ramo direito do feixe de His. Fol. med., Rio, 1941, 22: 121-3.— Doumer, E. Tachycardie d'apparence essentielle avec bloc incomplet de la branche droite du faisceau de His. Arch, mal cceur, 1932, 25: 741-51.—Dlugosz, H. [Partial block of the right fasciculus of the first and second type] Polska gaz. lek 1938, 17: 7-9, pl. ------ [Transitory bloc of the right branch] Ibid., 181-3, 4 pl.—Etienne, G., & Mathieu, L. Un cas de syndrome de Stokes-Adams; blocage permanent de la branche droite du faisceau de His. Rev. med. est, 1926, 54:' 490-3.— Evans, W., & Turnbull, H. M. The newer electrocardiogram denoting right bundle-branch block. Lancet, Lond., 1937, 2: 1127; 1184.—Fairley, K. D. The diagnosis and prognosis of complete block of the right branch of the bundle of His. Mel- bourne Hosp. Clin. Rep., 1930, 1: 33-40.—Gilsanz Garcia, V. Bloqueo de la rama derecha del fascfculo de His, con bloqueo intermitente auriculoventricular. Progr. cUn., Madr., 1933, 41: 368-72.—Kelly, L. W. Two-to-one right bundle branch block Am. Heart J., 1930-31, 6: 285-8.— Leinbach, R. F., & White, P. 1). Two to one right bundle-branch block. Ibid., 1927-28 3: 422-9.—Malcolm, W. S. Right branch bundle block. Brit M. J., 1927, 1: 372.—Malter Terrada, H. Significaci6n diag- n6stica del bloqueo de rama derecha; sindrome coronario anterior de Mahaim. Dfa med., B. Air., 1932-33, 5: 150 — Nisse, B. S. Myocardial degeneration with right branch block Proc R. Soc. M., Lond., 1928-29, 22: Sect. Clin., 56.—Padilla, T., & Cossio, P. Bloqueo de rama derecha del haz de His en afecciones del ventriculo izquierdo; sindrome de Kauf-Mahaim Rev. Soc. med. int., B. Air., 1931, 7: 119-28. Also Sem. med., B. Air., 1931, 38: 1489-92.—Petersen, O. V. C. E. [Course of block of right branch of the His-Tawara bundle] Hospitals- tidende, 1922, 65: 613-22.—Schlesinger, B. Congenital heart with right bundle branch block. Proc R. Soc. M., Lond., 1927, 21: Sect. Stud. Dis. Child., 3.—Sorrentino, M. Blocco della branca destra del fascio di His con fibrillazione atriale. Riforma med., 1930, 46: 1161-8.—Tuchiya, S. An unusual case of partial block of the right Tawara's bundle branch. Orient. J Dis. Inf., Kycto, 1935, 17: 1, pl.—Wilson, F. N., Johnston, F. p., & Barker, P. S. Electrocardiograms of an unusual type in right bundle-branch block. Am. Heart J., 1934, 9: 472-9. ---- bundle branch: Wolff-Parkinson-White syndrome. Bishop, L. F., jr. Bundle branch block with short P-R interval in individuals without organic heart disease; case report with review of Uterature. Am. J. M. Sc, 1937, 194: 794-800, Sv i/lf° ,r?Pr-—Cassinis, U. Blocco di branca o sindrome di W olff-Parkinson-White? osservazioni su miUtari idonei ad' jncondizionato servizio. Gior. med. mil., 1940, 88: 652-5.— Evans, C. Bundle-branch block in a normal young man. Am. Heart J., 1937,14: 753-8.—Rakhlin, L. M. [Observations on no r^eas?,of Wolff- Parkmson and White] Ter. arkh., 1937,15: u uT",Sp,rague« H- B- Auricular fibrillation and bundle branch block in an apparently normal heart: a case report. Internat. Chn., 1937, 47. ser., 1: 186-90, 4 ch.—Wolferth, C. C. & Wood, F. C. The mechanism of production of short P-R intervals and prolonged QRS complexes in patients with pre- sumably undamaged hearts; hypothesis of an accessory path- way of auriculoventricular condition (bundle of Kent) Am. Heart J 1932, 8: 297-311.—Wolff, L., Parkinson, J., & White, f. U. Bundle-branch block with short P-R intreval in healthy young people prone to paroxysmal tachycardia. Ibid., 1929-30, 5: b85-704. ---- complete. Voigtberger, H. J. [W.] *Das Schicksal des totalen Blocks. 19p. 23cm. Lpz., 1937. HEART-BLOCK 243 HEART-BLOCK Baumann, W., & Naumann, W. Rontgenanatomische Befunde am Herzskelett beim totalen Herzblock. Fortsch. Rontgenstrahl., 1937, 56: 723-32.—Bloom, B., & Perlow, S. Complete heart-block associated with rapid ventricular rate; report of 2 cases. Am. Heart J., 1929-30, 5: 486-92.—Borst, W. Zur Klinik des totalen Herzblocks. Deut.- med. Wschr., 1937, 63* 1189-93.—Bourne, C. R. Complete heart block; report of a case. Canad. M. Ass. J., 1926, 16: 1110.—Cimmino, M. Blocco cardiaco completo in una bambina di 12 anni. Pedi- atria (Riv.) 1932, 40: 605-10.—Erlanger, J. An instance of complete heart-block in man. Proc. Am. Physiol. Soc, 1904-5, p. xxvi.—Gallavardin, L. Pouls lent parfaitement toiere, par block total. Bull. Soc med. hop. Lyon, 1911, 649-55. Sur un cas rare de coexistence d'angine de poitrine d'effort et de pouls lent permanent par block total; acces angineux k forme syncopale et mort subite dans un acces. Lyon med., 1931, 147: 111-7.—Gilchrist, A. R., & Cohn, A. E. Varying ventricular complexes in complete heart block; an account of a postmortem examination in 1 case. Am. Heart J., 1927-28, 3- 146-76.—Gordon, K. Some cUnical features of complete heart-block. Canad. M. Ass. J., 1934, 31: 171-4.—Hunt, G. H. Case of complete heart block. Proc. R. Soc. M„ Lond., 1912-13, 6: Clin. Sect., 221.—Kelsey, H. A case of complete heart block. Med. J. Australia, 1914, 1:471.—Kemal Sara- coglu [Case of total heart-block with sinusoid bradycardia] Bull. Soc turque med., 1941, 7: 155-8.—Kisch, B. Beobach- tungen bei einem Kranken mit totalem Block. Cardiologia, Basel, 1938, 2: 47-55.—Konstam. Complete heart block: Adams-Stokes' attacks. West London M. J., 1935, 40:82.— Leech, C. B. Complete heart block in young people. Rhode Island M. J., 1934, 17: 112-8.—Liljestrand, G., & Zander, E. Studies of the work of the heart during rest and muscular activity in a case of uncomplicated total heart-block. Acta med. scand., 1927, 66: 501-17.—Lukin, N., & Frey, D. I. Total heart block in a child 8 years old. Arch. Pediat., N. Y., 1927, 44: 647-52.—Miller, D. H. Complete heart block, particularly in its prognostic aspects; report of 9 cases. Med. Bull. Veterans Admin., 1939-40, 16: 120-31.—Nuret Karasu, & Celal Ertug [Case of total block] Askeri sihhiye mecmuasii 1940, 69: 118-22.—Parsons-Smith, B. T. Complete heart block. Proc. R. Soc. M., Lond., 1926-27, 20: Sect. Clin., 34.— Perry, C. B. Three cases of complete heart block in children. Ibid., 1931, 24: 1612-5. Also repr.—Read, J. M. Heart- block; complete, compensated; report of cases. California West. M., 1929, 31: 12-7. ------ Complete heart block; Roentgen-kymographic study. Arch. Int. M., 1930, 45: 59-71. Also repr.—Rosenson, W. A case of complete heart block. Med. Rec, N.Y., 1920, 97:708.—Smith, H.L. Com- plete heart-block of 30 years' duration. Am. Heart J., 1933, 8: 719—21.—Strong, G. F. Paroxysmal ventricular tachycardia complicating complete heart block (with report of a case) Canad. M. Ass. J., 1934, 30: 507.—Whately-Davidson. Com- plete heart block with Stokes-Adams syndrome. Newcastle M. J., 1923-24, 4: 4.—Willius, F. A. Complete heart block of unusually long duration. Proc. Mayo Clin., 1931, 6: 196- 200.—Zander, E. Recherches sur Taction du cceur au repos et durant le travail dans un cas de heart block total et non compUque. Acta med. scand., 1926, Suppl., 16: 433-7. ---- complete: Etiology and Pathogenesis. Arndt, J. (Perpetuierliches) Vorhofflimmern bei perma- nenter Kammerautomatie; eine klinische Beobachtung auf dem Grenzgebiete des kompletten Herzblocks und der Arhyth- mia perpetua. Zschr. klin. Med., 1913, 78: 526-42.—Bischoff. Beobachtungen an einem Fall von vollstandigem Herzblock mit besonderer Berucksichtigung der kymographischen und kymographisch-elektrokardiographischen Befunde. Klin. Wschr., 1936, 15: 702-5.—Bishop, L. F. Adams-Stokes disease with complete heart block, showing a conspicuous lesion in the path of the auriculoventricular bundle. Am. J. M. Sc, 1910, 139: 62-5. Also repr.—Boas, E. P. Spontaneous variations in ventricular rate in complete heart block. J. Mount Sinai Hosp. N. York, 1935-36, 2: 95-102. Also repr.—Boer, S. de [Ventricular fibrillation in total heart-block] Ned. tschr. geneesk., 1926, 70: pt 2, 2617-24.—Coelho, E. Le mecanisme de la variation de forme des complexes ventriculaires dans le block complet du coeur. Arch. mal. cceur, 1932, 25: 695-702.— Coffen, T. H. Complete heart-block of 7 years* duration in a child resulting from injury. Am. Heart J., 1929-20, 5: 667-70. ----■— Rush, H. P., & Miller, R. F. Traumatic complete heart block of 18 years duration; with review of literature. Northwest M., 1941, 40: 195-200.—Cossali, C. Osservazioni elettrocardiografiche sul blocco completo del cuore (doppio ritmo ventricolare e modificazioni del penodo sinusale) Cuore & circol., 1935, 19: 513-23, ch.—Ellis, L. B. Studies in complete heart block: a clinical analysis of 43 cases. Am. J. M. Sc, 1932, 183: 225-35.—Fanielle & Neujean. Un cas de block complet avec autopsie. Ann. Soc. med. chir., Liege, 1934, 67: 101-3. Also Liege med., 1934, 27: 771.—Feher, S. Ueber Pulsationserscheinungen bei einem kompletten Herzblock. Mitt. Ges. inn. Med. Wien, 1933, 32: 96.—Gallavardin, L., & Dufourt, P. Block total et fibrillations auriculaire sans accidents nerveux. Bull. Soc. med. h6p. Lyon, 1913, 11: 660.—Henderson, J., & Rennie, J. K. Case of auricular flutter with full heart block. Glasgow M. J., 1927, 108: 355-8.—Heninger, B. R., & Dickens, K. L. Complete heart block from sclerosis of the bundle of His. Ann. Int. M., 1936-37,10: 696-701.—Herapath, C. E. K. Changes in ventri- cular rate associated with Stokes-Adams attacks in complete heart-block. Lancet, Lond., 1926, 1: 653-6.—Horine, E. F., & Weiss, M. M. Concomitant complete heart-block and bundle- branch block. J. Lab. Clin. M., 1934-35, 20: 1167-9 — £os£jn,c,J' TA c?se of Preimancy with complete heart block. Tr. M Soc. London, 1926-27, 50: 3-5—Jochim, K. The con- tribution of the auricles to ventricular filling in complete heart block. Am. J Physiol., 1938, 122: 639-45.— Krumbhaar, •xl APams-Stokes syndrome, with complete heart-block without destruction of the bundle of His. Arch. Int M 1910, 5: 583-95, 2 pl. Also Proc Path. Soc Philadelphia! 1910 n. ser., 13: 107-14.—Laubry, C, & Soulie, P. Bloc complet et auricular flutter. Arch. mal. cceur, 1938, 31 • 463-7.—Lemos Torres, A. Sobre um caso de bloqueio com- plete sem lesao do feixe de His. Ann. paul. med. cir., 1917, 8: 130-41.—Liihr, K. Eine besondere Form von Kammerarryth- rnie bei totalem Block. Klin. Wschr., 1934, 13: 807.—Naish A. E. The ventricular rate in complete heart-block. Brit' ,- J" 491,3' 1:, 491-—Oppenheimer, B. S., & Williams, u j\ p,roI1?nsed complete heart-block, without lesion of the bundle of His and with frequent changes in the idio-ventricular electrical complexes [Abstr.] Proc Soc. Exp. Biol, N Y 1912-13, 10: 86.—Petzetakis. Sur un cas de block total d origine syphihtique toiere pendant plusieurs annees et modifie apres un essai du traitement specifique. Arch. mal. cceur 1929, 22: 604-8.—Routier, D., Mamou, H., & Lemant, J. Bloc complet et auricular flutter. Ibid., 1936, 29: 369-82.— Saltzman, F. [Complete heart-block with relatively high ventricle frequency] Fin. lak. sail, hand., 1935, 78: 446-55.— Scherf, D., & Schott, A. Ueber die Ursache des Formwechsels automatischer Kammerschlage beim vollstandigen Herzblock. KUn. Wschr., 1932, 11: 945-7.—Schlomka, G., & Lehmann, U. Zur Bewertung der relativen Systolendauer; iiber die relative QT-Dauer bei totalem Block. Zschr. Kreislaufforsch., 1941, 33: 109-20.—Sharma, G. L. A case of cardiac failure with complete heart block. Ind. M. Gaz., 1934, 69: 446.—Smith, K. S. Coronary thrombosis and complete heart-block; with a note on the febrile reaction in cardiac infarction. Lancet, Lond., 1930, 1: 685-7.—Solomianny, B. M., & Bukspan, M. K. [A case of complete heart-block with ventricular flutter] Odess. med. J., 1928, 3: 601-4.—Soltzman, F. Die Ursachen einer verhaltnissmassig hohen Kammerfrequenz bei komplet- tem Herzblock. Acta med. scand., 1936, Suppl. 78, 271-7.— Steuer, L. G. Complete heart-block in hyperthyroidism; report of a case. Am. Heart J., 1936, 11: 623-5.—Swift, E. V., & Smith, H. L. Complete heart block associated with pneu- monia and peritonitis; review of the literature and report of a case in which a lesion was demonstrated histologically. J. Am. M. Ass., 1937, 109: 2038-42.—White, P. D. Auricular fibrillation and complete heart-block. Boston M. & S. J., 1915, 173: 431.—Willius, F. A. Auricular flutter with estab- lished complete heart-block. Am. Heart J., 1926-27, 2: 449-52.—Wilson, W. J. Report of a case of complete heart- block with autopsy findings; syphilitic myocarditis and aor- titis. Ann. Int. M., 1928-29, 2: 669-72. ---- complete: Treatment. Bachmann, G. Sphygmographic study of a case of complete heart-block; a contribution to the study of the action of strophanthus on the human heart. Arch. Int. M., 1909, 4: 238-52.—Bagnaresi, G., & Capo, R. Blocco cardiaco totale immodificabile con ritmo ventricolare accelerato daU'atropina. Minerva med., Tor., 1929, 9: pt 2, 717-25.—Boer, S. de. Kammerflimmern bei totalem Herzblock und die Wirkung von Chinidin oder Chininpraparaten bei totalem Herzblock. Zschr. Kreislaufforsch., 1927, 19: 56-67.—Cheer, S. N., Tung, C. L., & Bien, C. W. Combined effect of ephedrin and atropin on complete heart block. Proc Soc Exp. Biol., N. Y., 1932, 29: 1276. Also Am. Heart J., 1932, 8: 400-11.— Drake, E. H. A case of complete heart-block with interesting reaction to drugs. Ibid., 1927-28, 3: 560-6.—Freund, H. A. Management of complete heart block. Harper Hosp. Bull., Detr., 1941, 1: 4-7.—Gilchrist, A. R. The action of atropine in complete heart-block. Q. J. Med., Lond., 1933, n. ser., 2: 483-98, 2 pl. ------ The action of adrenaUn in complete heart-block. Ibid., 499-519, 3 pl. ------ The effects of bodily rest, muscular activity and induced pyrexia on the ventricular rate in complete heart-block. Ibid., 1934, n. ser., 3: 381-99, pl. ------ The action of amyl nitrite in complete heart-block. J. Pharm. Exp. Ther., 1934, 50: 286-97.— Oefelein, F. Beitrag zur Diagnostik und Therapie des kom- pletten Herzblockes. Zschr. Kreislaufforsch., 1934, 26: 782-8.—Poole, E. B., & Wilkinson, G. R. Complete heart block: reversion to normal sinus rhythm after the use of small doses of benzedrine sulphate; case report. South. M. J., 1937, 30: 1226.—Schwartz, S. P. Toxic manifestations of barium chloride in a patient with complete heart-block. Am. Heart J., 1928-29, 4: 612-4. -----■ & Jezer, A. The action of adrenaUn on patients with complete heart-block and Stokes- Adams seizures. Ibid., 1932, 7: 652-67. ---- Complication. Dressier, W. Schwangerschaft und Herzblock. Wien. Arch. inn. Med., 1927, 14: 83-96.—Greenhili, J. P. Heart- block in pregnant women. Am. J. Obst., 1933, 25: 125-8.— Ittner, G. W. A case of heart block with ventricular fibrillation. Week. Bull. S. Louis M. Soc, 1939-40, 34: 484.—Kauf, E. Herzblock und Vorhofflimmern. Zschr. Kreislaufforsch., 1927, 19: 377-86.—Monteiro de Barros, O., Rodrigues Ferreira, A. HEART-BLOCK 244 HEART-BLOCK et al.] Fibrillacao auricular, bloqueio auriculo-ventricular completo e bloqueio intraventricular, como complicacao cardiaca da achalasia; megaesophago-megacolon. Rev. clin. S. Paulo, 1940, 8: 12-6.—Scholder, B. M. Heart block and pregnancy; report of a case, with electrocardiographic observa- tions during cesarean section under cyclopropane anesthesia. Am. J. Obst., 1939. 38: 320-2. ---- congenital. Aitken, J. K. Congenital heart-block. N. York State J. M., 1933, 33: 1375-9.—Blackford, L. M., & McGehee, H. M. Congenital ln-ai t-block; a case with other cardiac anomalies in a student of 21 years. Am. Heart J., 1933, 9: 96-100.— Cammann, O. Angeborene Storungen der Erregungsiiber- leitung zwischen Herzvorhof und -kammer. Mschr. Kinderh., 1936, 66: 278-87.—Campbell, M., & Suzman, S. S. Congenita) complete heart-block; an account of 8 cases. Am. Heart J., 1934, 9: 304-23.—Cardelle, G., Pereiras, R., & De la Torre, H. Bloqueo cardiaco congenito; situs inversus totalis; y comunica- ci6n interventricular en un lactante de 11 meses; reporte de un caso. Vida nueva, Habana, 1941, 48: 209-20.—Casaubon, A., Kreutzer, R., & Cucullu, L. M. Bradiritmia por bloqueo auriculoventricular congenito y comunicaci6n interventricular, sindrome de Morquio. Arch, argent, pediat., 1941, 16: 411.— Castilla, C. R., & Aguirre, R. S. Bloqueo cardiaco congenito con sindrome de Stokes-Adams por crisis de taquicardia ventri- cular paroxistica y fibrilacion ventricular terminal. Ibid. 409.—Currie, G. M. A case of congenital complete heart- block; the effect of atropine. Brit. M. J., 1940, 1: 769.— Davis, H., & Stecher, R. M. Congenital heart block; report of au additional case, with review of literature. Am. J. Dis. Child., 1928, 36: 115-22.—Fleming, G. B., & Stevenson, M. M. Heart block associated with congenital malformation of the bcait. Arch. Dis. Childh., Lond., 1928, 3: 221-6.—Geiger, ('. J., & Hines, L. E. Prenatal diagnosis of complete congenital heart block. J. Am. M. Ass., 1940, 115: 2272.—Gianelli, C. Sobre un caso de bloqueo cardiaco congenito. Arch, argent. pediat., 1935, 6: 125. Also Arch, pediat. Uruguay, 1935, 6: 513-8.—Greenbaum, L. H. Congenital heart-block. Cali- fornia West. M., 1933, 38: 434.—Hall, A. S. Congenital complete heart block with Charcot-Marie-Tooth peroneal muscular atrophy. Proc. R. Soc. M., Lond., 1934, 27: 1233 — Haverschmidt, J. [Case of congenital heart-block] Ned. Isehr. geneesk., 1928, 72: 1166.—Hays, L. Report of 3 cases of congenital heart-block with a r6sume of the literature to date. J. Pediat., iS. Louis, 1934, 4: 380-6.—Heubner, D. Tuber die Bedeutung von Herzblock bei Neugeborenen. Zschr. kieislaufforscli., 1938, 30: 600-2- Kinsman, J. M.,& Andrews, H. S. Congenital heart block. J. Am. M. Ass., 1935, 104: 393-5.—Koenen, H. P. J. [Congenital complete heart block] Ned. tschr. geneesk., 1930, 74: pt 2, 6000, pl.—Lampard, M. E. Heart block associated with congenital heart disease. Arch. Dis. Childh., Lond., 1928, 3: 212-20.—Leech, C. B. Con- genital complete heart block; report of a case with an associ- ated patent ductus arteriosus. Am. J. Dis. Child., 1930, 39: 131-40. Also repr.—Levine, H. D. A case of congenital complete heart-block with labile ventricular rate. Am. Heart J., 1934-35, 10: 376-83.—Lewis, J. A case of congenital heart-block. Brit. M. J., 1934, 2: 1096.—Lukl, P. [Congenital block and interventricular communication] Cas. lek. cesk., 1935, 74: 1344-8.—Mcintosh, R. Congenital heart block; report of a case. Am. J. Dis. Child., 1927, 34: 965-8.—Nicolson, G., Shulman, H. L, & Green, D. L. Congenital heart block; with report of a case. Ibid., 1929, 37: 580-90.—Nielsen, A. L. Zwei Falle von angeborenem Herzblock. Acta paediat, Upps., 1935, 17: 554-64. Also Ugeskr. laeger, 1935, 97: 782.— Nisse, B. S. Congenital malformation of the heart associated with heart block. Proc R. Soc. M., Lond., 1927-28, 21: Sect. Clin., 40-2.—Ottow, B. Intrauterine Wahrscheinlich- keitsdiagnose eines Herzblocks bei der Frucht, klinisch am Neugeborenen bestatigt. Zbl. Gyn., 1939, 63: 715-9.— Perez de los Reyes, R., & De la Torre, H. Contribuci6n al estudio de los bloqueos cardlacos congenitos. Bol. Soc cubana pediat., 1938, 10: 446-56.—Perotti, D. Blocco cardiaco con- genito con vizio di conformazione del cuore. Boll. Soc. med. chir., Pavia, 1928, n. ser., 3: 1-11.—Rodgers, T. S. Congenital heart-block. Proc. R. Soc. M., Lond., 1934, 27: Sect. Dis. Child., 415.—Sclar, M. Congenital heart-block; report of a case. Am. Heart J., 1930-31, 6: 289-92.—Shapiro, M. J. Heart-block of congenital origin; report of a case. Minnesota M., 1927, 10: 566-8.—Sipek, J. [Case of congenital heart- block; study of the auricle T wave] Voj. zdrav. listy, 1938 14: 100-6.—Wallgren, A., & Winblad, S. Congenital heart-block Acta paediat., Upps., 1937-38, 20: 175-204.—Wilson, J. G., & Grant, R. T. A case of congenital malformation of the heart in an infant associated with partial heart block. Heart Lond 1925-26, 12: 295-305—Yater, W. M. Congenital heart block'; report of a case with incomplete heterotaxy. Proc Mayo Clin 1928, 3: 320-2. ------ Congenital heart-block; review of the literature; report of a case with incomplete heterotaxy the electrocardiogram in dextrocardia. Am. J. Dis Child ' 1929, 38: 112-36. ------ Leaman, W. G., & Cornell, V. h' Congenital heart block; report of the third case of complete heart block studied by serial sections through the conduction system. J. Am. M. Ass., 1934, 102: 1660-4.—Yater, W M Lyon, J. A., & McNabb, P. E. Congenital heart block; review and report of the second case of complete heart block studies by serial sections through the conduction system. Ibid. 1933 100:1831-7. Also repr. Diagnosis. Heisinc:, H. *Beitrag zur Klinik und Elektro- kardiographie des Herzblocks [Konigsberg] 47p. 8! Bethel-Bielefeld, 1936. Wirth, R. *Ueber Storungen des Reiz- leitungssystems des Herzens und deren Beur- teilung. 23p. 8? Berl., 1927. Brown, W. H. A study of the esophageal lead in clinical electrocardiography; the application of the esophageal lead to the human subject with observations on the Ta-wave, extrasystoles and bundle-branch block. Am. Heart J., 1936, 12, 1:1-45.—King, R. L., & Wood, J. E., jr. The recognition and prognosis of the various types of heart block. Virginia M. Month., 1929-30, 56: 1-7.—Pieraccini, C. II valore se meiotico della intermittenza cardiaca soggettivamento a|>pri-z- zata al preeordio. Rass. stud, psichiat., 1930, 19: 267-78. Wilson, J. M. The electrocardiographic study of the various forms of heart-block. Internat. Clin., 1927, 37. ser., 3: 16-23 15 pl. ---- Dissociation. Fischer, R. Ueber das Vorkommen einfacher zahlenmiis- siger Beziehungen zwischen der Frequenz dissoziiert schlagendcr Herzabschnitte. Zschr. klin. Med., 1931, 116: 466-77.— Frederico, L. Dissociation par compression graduee des voies motrices et arrestatrices contenues dans le faisceau de His. Bull. Acad. Belgique, 1911, cl. sc, 873-85.—Lian, C. Du pouls lent permanent par dissociation et sans accidents nerveux k aucune periode de son evolution (pouls lent permanent soli- taire) Progr. med., Par., 1911, 3. ser., 27: 547-52. ---- Dissociation, auricular. See also Heart-block, auricular. Calandre, L. Trastornos de conduction interauricularcs. An. Hosp. S. Jose, Madr., 1931-32, 3: 74-8.—Hertz, J. A case of double auricular action with one-sided block. Acta med. scand., 1939, 101: 409-18.—Lian, C, & Golblin, V. Un cas de double rythme auriculaire par dissociation inter- auriculaire. Arch. mal. coeur, 1938, 31: 52-6.—Scherf, D., & Siedek, H. Ueber Block zwischen beiden Vorhofen. Zschr. klin. Med., 1934, 127: 77-88.—Spuhler, O. Zur Kenntnis der sino- und inter-aurikularen Leitungsstorungen. Cardiologia, Basel, 1939, 3: 244-69—Zarday, I. [Clinical significance of atrial asynchronia] Orv. hetil., 1936, 80: 1157-9. ---- Dissociation, auriculo-ventricular. Jeannacopoulo, J. *Dissociation auriculo- ventriculaire et grossesse. 77p. 8? Pur., 1932. Webek, J. * Ueber Dissociation von Vorhof- und Kammerrhythmus. 23p. 8? Bonn, 1908. Ashman, R., & Gouaux, J. L. Reflex inhibition of the human heart: complete A-V block and parasystole. Proc. Soc. Exp. Biol., N. Y., 1937-38, 37: 25-7.—Bard, L. Le pronostic de la dissociation auriculo-ventriculaire chez les sujets jeunes. Bull. Soc. med. hop. Paris, 1928, 3. ser., 52: 510-2.—Battro, A., & Braun Menendez, E. La radioquimograffa en el bloqueo total auriculo-ventrieular. Rev. argent, card., 1936-37, 3: 199-206.—Braun Mengndez, E., & Solari, L. A. Estudio del ruido auricular en el bloqueo total auriculo-ventricular experi- mental. Rev. Soc. argent, biol., 1936, 12: 112-20.—Buchem. F. S. P. van. Dissoziation zwischen Atrium und Ventrikel; Erklarung des partiellen Herzblocks. Zschr. klin. Med., 1929, 110: 401-26.—Clerc, A., & Levy, R. Evolution de la dissociation auriculo-ventriculaire chez les jeunes sujets, Bull. Soc med. hop. Paris, 1928, 3. ser., 52: 490-8. ----- Sur la resistance du coeur chez certains malades en etat de dissociation auriculoventriculaire permanente. Arch. mal. cceur, 1936, 29: 307-34.—Cossio, P., & Lascalea, L. Un nuevo signo auscultatorio de bloqueo total auriculo-ventricular. Rev. argent, card., 1934-35, 1: 276-80.—D'Arbela, F. Sopra un caso di blocco completo atrioventricolare. Baglivi, 1939, 5: 65-74.—Finkelnburg, R. Ueber Dissoziation von Vorhof- und Kammerrhytmus. Deut. Arch. klin. Med., 1906, 86: 4.62-7, pl.—Francaviglia, A. Dissociazione atrio-ventricolare simulante ritmo nodale. Clin. med. ital., 1938, 69: 769-79 — Goteling Vinnis, E. W. [Lack of harmony between atrial and ventricular rhythm in its most severe form] Ned. mschr. geneesk., 1920, 1: 113-8, pl.—Hecht, A. F. Atrioventrikulare Dissoziation. Wien. klin. Wschr., 1917, 30: 163.—HUbener, G. Zur Prognose des kompletten A-V-Blocks. Zschr. Kreis- laufforsch., 1935, 27: 444-8.—Jeannin, C, & Clerc, A. Dissoci- ation auriculo-ventriculaire et grossesse. Bull. Soc med. h6p. Paris, 1927, 3. ser., 122-7.—Joselevich, M. Bloqueo auriculo-ventricular completo; complejos ventriculares de forma variable. Sem. med., B. Air., 1934, 41: pt 2, 1835-9.— Lemieux, R., & Drouin, G. A propos d'un cas de dissociation auriculo-ventriculaire. Laval m6d., 1940, 5: 245-52.—Lian, C, & Barrieu. Bradycardies par dissociation auriculo-ventri- culaire chez les sujets jeunes. Progr. med., Par., 1929, 44: ,194- Pezzi, C. II segno della danza ilare; sua interpretazione in un caso di dissociazione atrio-ventricolare completa. Cuore & circol., 1927, 11: 381-9.—Pletnew, D. Ein Fall von trans- versaler Dissoziation. Zschr. klin. Med. 1911. 74: 10-2.— HEART-BLOCK Posteli, T. II comportamento della pressione arteriosa nelle bradicardie da dissociazione atrio-ventricolare. Arch, pat., Bologna, 1938-39, 18: 409-58.—Pfikryl, Z. [Prognosis in complete atrioventricular block] Cas. lek. Cesk., 1936, 75: 131-3.—Prusik, B. K. [Complete auriculoventricular block] Ibid., 1924, 63: 369-78, pl.—Simici, D., Dumitru, I., & Popesco, M. Considerations sur un cas de dissociation auriculo-ventri- culaire complete et permanente juvenile. Arch. mal. coeur, 1931, 24: 94-105.—Soulie, P. Dissociation auriculo-ventricu- laire avec pauses prolongees suivies de crises de tachycardie ventriculaire; considerations sur les troubles respiratoires. Ibid., 1938, 31: 111-9.—Stenstrom, N. Recovery from complete A-V block in a case of endocarditis with post mortem examination. Acta med. scand., 1927, 67: 185-8, 3 pl.— Strauss, H. A case of sino-auricular block and almost complete A-V dissociation without primary A-V block. Am. Heart J., 1934-35, 10: 553-6.—Tourreilles, J. F., & Vazquez, P. C. Bloqueo auriculo-ventricular total por digital. Prensa med. argent., 1935, 22: 1119-22.—Wertheimer, E., & Combemale, P. Sur quelques formes de dissociation auriculo-ventriculaire. Arch, internat. physiol., Liege, 1922-23, 20: 113-30. ---- Dissociation, auriculo-ventricular, con- genital. Brenner, J. [Congenital complete atrio-ventricular block] Orv. hetil., 1941, 85: 244.—Cald, A. Malformazione cardiaca e dissociazione atrio-ventricolare completa congenita. Cuore & circol., 1938, 22: 323-35.—Delgado Correa, B., & Cordero Sloan, F. E. Pulso lento permanente congenito por disociaci6n auriculoventricular. Arch, argent, pediat., 1935, 6: 199.— Giroux, R., & Katsilabros, _L. Brady cardies congenitales par dissociation auriculo-ventriculaire; k propos d'un cas. Paris med., 1928, 69: 30-5.—Gj0rup, E. [Complete congenital atrioventricular block in a 9 vear old boy] Hospitalstidende, 1933, 76: 977-83.—Mathieu, L., Pierquin, L., & Botkovitz, F. La forme habitueUe de la dissociation auriculo-ventriculaire congenitale. Rev. med. Nancy, 1937, 65: 467; 515.—Mathieu, L., & Simonin, J. Pouls lent permanent juv6nUe par dissocia- tion auriculo-ventriculaire compUquee de communication inter- ventriculaire et retretissement pulmonaire. Rev. med. est, 1930, 58: 9-13.—Rosa, V. C, de & Rez Masud, P. Un caso de bradicardia congenita por disociacion auriculo-ventricular. Sem. med., B. Air., 1934, 41: 1313-8.—Witt, D. B. Congenita] complete auriculoventricular heart block. Am. J. Dis. Child., 1934, 47: 380-7" ---- Dissociation, auriculo-ventricular: Inter- ference. Bain, C. W. C. Interference dissociation. Lancet, Lond., 1939, 1: 20-2.—Buchem, F. S. P. van [Case of dissociation with interference] Ned. tschr. geneesk., 1929, 73: 1692-702.— Bullrich, R. A., & Sneider, D. Diaociaci6n auriculo-ventricular transitoria a ritmo ventricular rdpido; influencia de la digitalo- terapia. Rev. argent, card., 1937-38, 4: 347-53.—Doleschall, F. Beitrag zur Frage der Interferenzdissoziation. Deut. Arch. Win. Med., 1933-34, 176: 173-7.—Duvoir. M., Pautrat, J. [et al.] Etude eiectrocardiographique d'un cas d'interference dissociation. Arch. mal. coeur, 1937, 30: 562-7.—Enescu, I., & Vacareanu, N. Dissociation auriculo-ventriculaire isoryth- mique transitoire. Ibid., 1934, 27: 691-703.—Froment, R. Dissociations auriculo-ventriculaires par defaut de subordina- tion; dissociations auriculo-ventriculaires, iso-rythmiques et interferentieUes; blocks partiels mitigcs de dissociation com- plete. Presse med., 1938, 46: 97-100. ------ & Gonin, A. Dissociation auriculo-ventriculaire complete avec alternance reguUcre de pause et de tachycardie ventriculaires. Arch. mal. coeur, 1938, 31: 645-58.—Gallavardin, L., & Froment, R. Tachycardies ventriculaires pre-fibrillatoires au cours du blocage par dissociation auriculo-ventriculaire. Ibid., 1931, 24: 670-9.—Haas, A. K. J. de. Un cas exceptionnel d'interference du rythme sinusal normal avec un rythme idioventriculaire heterotopique. Ibid., 684-91.—Herrmann, G., & Ashman, R. Interference dissociation in contrast to reciprocating rhythm. Proc Soc. Exp. Biol., N. Y., 1930-31, 28: 264.—Hill, I. G. W., & Cameron, J. D. S. A case of parasystole showing simple interference dissociation. Am. Heart J., 1936, 11: 140-62.— Laubry, C, & Lequime, J. A propos d'un cas de dissociation auriculo-ventriculaire k rythme ventriculaire rapide. Arch. mal. cceur, 1933, 26: 353-90, diagr.—Ledoux, E., & Arcay, G. Un cas de dissociation auriculo-ventriculaire avec rythme ventriculaire rapide. Ibid., 1936, 29: 219-23.—Lequime, J., & Sanabria, T. Contribution k l'etude anatomo-clinique de la dissociation auriculo-ventriculaire permanente k rythme ven- triculaire rapide. Ibid., 1939, 32: 27-34.—Lopez-Brenes. Bloqueo A-V completo con ritmo idioventricular taquicdrdio. Progr. clin., Madr., 1933, 41: 348-55.—Michelazzi, A. M. Contributo alio studio dei ritmi doppi; da due osservazioni di dissociazione isoritmica. Rass. fisiopat., 1938, 10: 674-85.— Rasario, G. M. Dissociazione isoritmica e dissociazione con interferenza secondarie a choc coronarico. Fol. med., Nap., 1938, 24: 983-93, 3 tab.—Savy. P., Veil, P., & Naussac, H. A propos d'un type eiectrocardiographique exceptionnel de tachycardie paroxystique avec dissociation auriculo-ventricu- laire isorythmique. Arch. mal. coeur, 1933, 26: 256-66.— Schott, A. Dissociation with interference of the heart with observations of 5 new cases. Guy's Hosp. Rep., Lond.. 1937, 87: 21.5-28.—Segura, G., Israel, J. E., & Ferretti, J. Sobre un caso de disociaci6n auriculo-ventricular por interferencia. HEART-BLOCK Prensa med. argent., 1937, 24: 1344-9.—Voss, E. Ein Fall von Interferenzdissoziation unter Vaguseinfluss. Zschr. Kreislauf- forsch., 1934, 26: 161-6. ---- Dissociation, auriculo-ventricular: Mani- festation. Birotheau, E. *Etude clinique et graphique du pouls lent par dissociation auriculo-ventricu- laire. 2l8p. 8? Par., 1911. _ Nikoff, D. *Le rythme bigemine dans les dissociations auriculo-ventriculaires. 84p. 8? Par., 1934. Steckf.er, J. *Les formes tachysphygmiquos de la dissociation auriculo-ventriculaire. 24p. 8? Lausanne, 1936. Bachmann, G. Complete auriculoventricular dissociation without syncopal or epileptiform attacks. Am. J. M. Sc, 1909, n. ser., 137: 342-64.—Bessone, F. Le forme parossistiche di dissociazione atrioventricolare. Minerva med., Tor., 1928, 8: 671-87.—Boas, E. P., & Schwartz, S. P. Transient auriculo- ventricular dissociation with pararrhythmia in a rooster. Med. Rec, N. Y., 1936, 143: 50-2.—Castex, M. R., Lopez Ramirez, R., & Repetto, R. L. Pulso lento permanente por bloqueo A. V, completo con inversion paroxfstica de la f6rmula eiectrica ventricular. Prensa med. argent., 1927,14: 749-54. Also Rev. Soc med. int., B. Air., 1927, 3: 639-52.—Coelho, E. Tachy- cardie ventriculaire au cours de la maladie d'Adams-Stokes par dissociation auriculo-ventriculaire. Arch. mal. coeur, 1932, 25: 232-7.—Cossio, P., & Braun Menendez, E. Estudio fonocardiografico del bloqueo total auriculo-ventricular. Rev. argent, card., 1935-36, 2: 1-16.—De Matteis, F. Sull'onda P negativa posposta aU'oscillazione ventricolare iniziale nei blocco a-y totale. Minerva med., Tor., 1936, 27: 9-11.—Diliberto, U. Ritmo nodale decapitato con dissociazione auricolo-ventricolare. Cuore & circol., 1933,17: 596-604.—Duchosal, P., & Bourdillon, J; L'eclat accidentel du premier bruit du cceur dans la disso- ciation auriculo-ventriculaire. Arch. mal. coeur, 1934, 27: 232-45.—Fischer, R.' Ueber das Verhalten des Pulses bei dissozierter Herztatigkeit. Wien. Arch. inn. Med., 1934, 25: 469-80.—Fogel, E. I. Recognition of dissociation of auricles and ventricles bv phasic variations of the heart sounds. J. Med., Cincin., 1936-37, 17: 135-7.—Geraudel, E. Un cas de dissociation auriculo-ventriculaire sur rythme de tachycardie. Cardiologia, Basel, 1937, 1: 9-16. ------ Laignel-Lavastine, P. M., & Boquien, V. Un cas d'Adams-Stokes; longues pauses ventriculaires traces de transition entre les 2 types de dissocia- tion. Arch. mal. coeur, 1933, 26: 1-20, diagr.—Graybiel, A., & White, P. D. Complete auriculo-ventricular dissociation; a clinical study of 72 cases with a note on a curious form of auricular arrhythmia frequently observed. Am. J. M. Sc, 1936, 192: 334-44.—Josue, O. Remarques sur le rythme auri- culaire dans les cas de pouls lent permanent par dissociation auriculo-ventriculaire. Bull. Soc. med. hop. Paris, 1911, 3. ser., 32: 139.—Kur6, K., & Kaneko, H. Ein Fall von Dissoziation der beiden Vorhofskontraktionen mit dem Kammersystolenaus- fall. Klin. Wschr., 1926, 5: 1523-5.—Lequime, J., & Sanabria, T. Contribution a l'etude anatomo-clinique du bloc auriculo- ventriculaire complet permanent k rythme ventriculaire lent. Arch. mal. cceur, 1937, 30: 670-81— Lian, C, Marchal, G., & Welti, J. J. Remarques phonocardiographiques sur les brady- cardies par dissociation auriculo-ventriculaire complete. Ibid., 1938, 31: 669-81.—Marchal, G., Routier, D., & Soulie, P. Bradycardie par dissociation complete avec deformations alternantes des complexes ventriculaires. Bull. Soc med. hop. Paris, 1936, 3. ser., 52:1230-3.—Odinet. Forma comtin del pulso lento permanente por disociaci6n auriculo-ventricular. Dfa med., B. Air., 1931-32, 4: 783; 789.—Pezzi, C, & Clarac, G. Controle et mise en valeur par la methode graphique de quelques phenomenes d'auscultation dans 2 cas de dissociation atrio- ventriculaire complete. Bull. Soc. med. hop. Paris, 1913, 3. ser., 35: 640-50.—Picchini, G. Sindrome di Morgagni-Adams- Stokes da ritmo periodico idio-ventriculare nei blocco atrio- ventricolare totale. Minerva med., Tor., 1935, 26: pt 2, 171- 7.—Puddu, V. Un segno ascoltatorio ppco noto della dissocia- azione atrio-ventricolare completa; il rinforzo accidentale del primo tono. BoU. Accad. med. Roma, 1939, 65:116.—Rubegni, R. Ricerche sui rapporti fra 2? tono e sistole elettrica nella dissociazione atrioventricolare completa. Cuore & circol., 1939, 23: 489-98.—Solomjany, B., & Boukspan, M. Un cas de dissociation auriculo-ventriculaire complete avec fibrillo-flutter. Arch. mal. cceur, 1929, 22: 305-8.—Soulie, P., Cattan, & Bachmann. Dissociation auriculo-ventriculaire complete avec flutter auriculaire paroxystique. Bull. Soc. med. h6p. Paris, 1936, 3. ser., 52: 445-50.—Stafneri, D. Sobre algunas particu- laridades del electro-cardiograma en la disociaci6n auriculo- ventricular completa. Rev. med. Rosario, 1934, 24: 760-4.— Taquini, A. C. Ruidos esofdgicos en el bloqueo completo auriculoventricular y en el aleteo auricular. Rev. Soc. argent. biol., 1937, 13: 49-51.—Teran, V. S. Tres observaciones de bloqueo auriculoventricular completo intermitente; curiosa arritmia auricular. Rev. argent, card., 1940-41, 7: 374-84.— Vedoya, R. Caracterfsticas poco comunes en un caso de disociaci6n A-V permanente. Ibid., 1938, 5: 248-62.—White, P. D. Un cas de dissociation auriculo-ventriculaire complete avec reduction transitoires k moitie de la frequence ventriculaire. Arch. mal. cceur, 1918, 11: 352-4. 2' HEART-BLOCK 246 HEART-BLOCK ---- Dissociation, auriculo-ventricular: Patho- genesis. Arnold, E. *Evolution et pronostic de la dissociation auriculo-ventriculaire chez les sujets jeunes. 80p. 8? Geneve, 1935. Herran, J. E. Estudio clinico y electro- cardiografico del bloqueo auriculoventricular completo en la difteria. 158p. 27cm. B. Air., 1939. Routier, D. *Etude critique sur les disso- ciations auriculo-ventriculaires. 77p. 8? Par., 1915. Agostoni, G. Riflessioni sulla patogenesi deUe dissociazioni atrio-ventricolari. BoU. spec. med. chir., 1927, 1: 17-21.— Capriglione, L., & Benchimol, A. B. Disociaci6n auriculo- ventricular por doble comando. Dfa med., B. Air., Ed. espec, 1939, 107-11.—Carriere & Huriez, C. Etude eiectrocardio- graphique de 3 cas de dissociation auriculo-ventriculaire (block ou double commande?) Echo med. nord, 1933, 37: 133-41.— Condorelli, L. Influenza deUe contrazioni ventricolari sul ritmo sinusale neUa dissociazione atrio-ventricolare. Cuore & circol., 1932, 16: 533-46, 3 diagr.—Cordero, A. Ueber die Veranderun- gen des Reizleitungssystems in 3 FaUen von atrioventrikularer Dissoziation. Zschr. Kreislaufforsch., 1934, 26: 288-93 — De Graff, A. C, & Weiss, S. Observations on the extrinsic nervous control of the auricles and ventricles in complete auric- ulo-ventricular block in man. J. CUn. Invest., 1925-26, 2: 227- 44.—Donzelot, E. Remarques sur l'automatisme cardiaque; k propos d'un cas de dissociation auriculo-venticulaire grave mais transitoire. Arch. mal. cceur, 1938, 31: 817-23.—Etinger, I. G. [Pathological physiology and clinical aspect of atrio- ventricular dissociation] Ter. arkh., 1937, 15: 77-98, 13 ch.— Fredericq, L. Dissociation par compression gradu6e des voies motrices et arrestatrices contenues dans la faisceau de His. Liege med., 1935, 28: 1034-6.—Geraudel, E. La dissociation auriculo-ventriculaire par double commande; critique de la theorie du block. Arch. mal. cceur, 1932, 25: 339; 385, 5 diagr. ------ La dissociation auriculo-ventriculaire par double commande; critique des rythmes nodaux. Ibid., 1933, 26: 320-38. ------ Une conception nouveUe de la dissociation auriculo-ventriculaire; la double commande. Presse med., 1934, 42: 814-6. ——---■ Le double commande; etude des traces oil coexistent deux commandes ind6pendantes, l'une auriculo-ventriculaire, l'autre auriculaire. Arch. mal. cceur, 1935, 28: 121-35, ch.—Giraud, P., Buisson & Astesiano. Malformation cardiaque avec pouls lent permanent par dis- sociation auriculo-ventriculaire. BuU. Soc. pediat. Paris, 1934, 32:555-8. Also Nourrisson, 1935, 23: 112.—Hahn, L. Initiale Querdissoziation mit Adams-Stokes'schen AnfaUen bei akutem Myokardinfarkt. Zschr. Kreislaufforsch., 1932, 24: 129-37.— Ledoux, E. Dissociation auriculo-ventriculaire transitoire avec deformation des ondes ventriculaires traduisant un bloc osculant des branches droite et gauche du faisceau de His. Arch. mal. cceur, 1938, 31: 618-24 [Discussion] 633.—Nicolai. Ueber die Dissoziation zwischen Atrium und Ventrikel und ihre Kompensation durch Allodromien. Verh. Deut. Kongr. inn. Med., 1910, 27: 631-3.—Nicolai, G. F., & Plesch, J. Der Reguiationsmechanismus bei-der volligen Dissoziation zwischen Vorhof und Kammer. Deut. med. Wschr., 1909, 35: 2252-6.— Padilla, T., & Cossio, P. Dissociation auriculo-ventriculaire par depression de l'automatisme sinusal. BuU. Soc. med. hop. Paris, 1931, 3. ser., 47: 49-53. Also Sem. m6d., B. Air., 1931, 38: 824-7.—Pareja, J. M. Periode de restauration super- normale dans une dissociation auriculo-ventriculaire complete. Arch. mal. coeur, 1933, 26: 395-407.—Pezzi, C. Considerazioni sopra due casi di dissociazione atrio-ventricolare completa. PoUcUnico, 1913, 20: sez. med., 455-67.—Vaghi, A. Riflessioni critiche sulle dissociazioni atrio-ventricolari sopratawariche in clinica. Arch. Ist. biochim. ital., 1935, 7: 342-52.—Yabumoto, H. Studien iiber die atrioventrikulare Dissoziation und ihre EinteUung. Mitt. Med. Ges. Tokyo, 1937, 51: 74. ---- Dissociation, auriculo-ventricular: Retro- grad conduction. Averbuck, S. H. Adams-Stokesscher Symptomenkomplex, Cheyne-Stokessche Atmung und riicklaufige Ueberleitung in einem Fall von komplettem Herzblock. Wien. Arch. inn. Med., 1932, 22: 49-84.—Barker, P. S. The occurrence of auricular beats due to stimulation of the auricles by the con- tracting ventricles during complete heart-block; a case report. Am. Heart J., 1925-26, 1: 349-53.—Geraudel, E. Du renverse- ment de la sequence oreUlette-ventricule: sa pathogenie. Bull. Acad, med., Par., 1926, 3. ser., 95: 627-9.—Schramm, E., & Korth, C. Ueber die Ruckleitung automatischer AV-Reize zum Vorhof bei komplettem AV-Block. Klin. Wschr., 1937. 16: 771-4. ---- Dissociation, auriculo-ventricular: Treat- ment. Poiriek, R. J. Contribution a l'etude de Taction du sulfate neutre d'atropine sur les dissociations auriculo-ventriculaires compliquees de bloc dc brunches. 47p. X? Par., 1938. Jourdonais, L. F., & Mosenthal, H. O. Complete auriculo- ventricular block and auricular flutler with observations of the effect of quinidine sulfate. Am. Heart J.. 1937, 14: 735 43.—Mondon, H. Bradycardie par dissociation auriculo- ventriculaire complete; letom a un rythme normal apres traitement snlicyle. Bull. Soc. nn'd. hdp. Paris, 1938, 3. ser., 54: 882-5.—Olmer, I)., Olmer, J. [et al.] Variations mor- phologiques des complexes ventriculaires spontanea et re- produces par injection d'adrenalinc au cours d'une dissociation A. X.; bloc septo-ventriculaire alternant et a bascule. Arch. mal. coeur, 1939, 32: 797-807. ----■ Dissociation, longitudinal. Schrumpf,. W. *Ueber Umkehrsystolen (re- ciprocating rhythm) zugleich ein Beitrag zur Frage der Langsdissoziation am mcnschliclien Herzen. 18p. 8? Berl., 1930. Kerr, W. J., & Sampson, J. J. Functional longitudinal block in the human heart; a probable case with unusual ar- rhythmia. Am. Heart J., 1932, 7: 574-80.—Korth, C, 4 Schrumpf, W. Ueber Umkehrsystolen (reciprocating Rhythm) zugleich ein Beitrag zur Frage der Langsdissoziation am menschlichen Herzen. Deut. Arch. klin. Med., 1935-36, 178: 589-603. ---- Etiology. Leitsmann [W. F.] G. *Fokale Infektion und ihre Beziehungen zum Reizleitungssystem dew Herzens. 47p. 8? Erlangen, 1935. Vandenplas, R. *Le bloc cardiaque trau- matique. 99p. 25y2cm. Par., 1938. Attinger, E. Beobachtungen uber die Aetiologie der Reiz- leitungsstorungen. Schweiz. med. Wschr., 1941, 71: 1176-80.— Blatt, A., & Ungar, M. [Case of heart block and uremia] Polska gaz. lek., 1929, 8: 799.—Bloch, E. Herzblock und Vorhofsflimmern; der Einfluss der extrakardialen Nerven auf den Ventrikelrhythmus. Klin. Wschr., 1926, 5: 1230-2.— Butler, S., & Levine, S. A. Diphtheria as a cause of late heart-block. Am. Heart J., 1929-30, 5: 592-8 — Cleland, J. B. Gumma of the intraventricular septum of the heart giving rise to heart block. Med. J. Australia, 1927, 1: 540.—Cookson, S. H. Heart block with alternate extra-systoles due to digi- talis. Birmingham M. Rev., 1926, n. ser., 1: 239-44.—Cowan, J., Fleming, G. B., & Kennedy, A. M. Nodal rhythm and heart-block in the acute infections. Tr. Internat. Congr. Med., Lond., 1914, Sect. VI, Medicine, pt 2, 233-54.—Delius, L. Klinischer Bericht iiber einen Fall von Herzblock bei Ventrikelseptumdefekt. Zschr. Kreislaufforsch., 1934, 26: 801-7.—Dlugacz, B. Ueber familiare Disposition zu Herz- block, zugleich ein Beitrag zur Frage des pathogenetischen Zusammenhanges zwischen Adam-Stokes' und Cheyne- Stokesschem Symptomenkomplex. Med. Klin., Berl., 1933, 29: 1109-11.—Duvoir, M., Pollet, L. [et al.] Bloc traumatique du coeur datant de 20 ans; rupture probable du septum. Bull. Soc. med. hop. Paris, 1937, 3. ser., 53: 451-60.—Henrijean. Les blocks cardiaques. Bull. Acad. med. Belgique, 1927, 5. ser., 7: 477-91, 3 pl.—Hutagawa, N. Heart block formation due to weal in the atrioventricular septum [Abstr.] Jap. J. Obst., 1939, 22: 49.—Kampmann, W. Ein Fall von isolierter Verletzung des Herzreizleitungssystems. Miinch. med. Wschr., 1935, 82: 129-31.—Lloyd, P. C. Heart block due to primary lymphangioendothelioma of atrio-ventricular node. Bull. Johns Hopkins Hosp., 1929, 44: 149-54.— Marzahn, H. Klinischer Beitrag zur Frage funktioneller Reizleitungs- storungen. Klin. Wschr., 1936, 15: 486-8.—Mbller, F. [Case of heart-block in (prefebrile) initial stage of polyarthritic infection] Sven. lak. tidn., 1931, 28: invart. med., 43-50.— Mohler, H. K. Heart block and uremia; report of 2 cases. J. Am. M. Ass., 1929, 92: 706-8.—Roy, B. M. A case of toxic heart-block due to Cerbera thevetia (yellow oleander seeds) Ind. M. Gaz., 1927, 62: 450.—Schilder, G. Ueber traumati- schen Herzblock. Med. Klin., Berl., 1935, 31: 1572-4.— Shapiro, P. Hypertensive heart disease with heart block. In Path. Conf. (Jaffe, R. H.) Chic, 1940, 251.—Uher, V. Zur Pathologie des Reizleitungssystems bei kongenitalen Herzanomalien. Frankf. Zschr. Path., 1935-36, 49: 349-54.— Wetzel, L. Herzblock bei Ventrikelseptumdefekt. Klin. Wschr., 1939, 18: 683-5. ---- experimental. Barton, E. M. Ligation of the arteries of the conduction system; a second attempt to produce heart block in dogs, Arch. Path., Chic, 1935, 19: 465-72.—Bellido, J. M. De la forma d'establiment i desaparicio del bloqueig en la tortuga. Tr. Soc biol., Barcel., 1916, 4: 52-5, 2 graph.—Bethe, A. Experimentelle Erzeugung von Storungen der Erregungs- leitung und von Alternans- und Periodenbildungen bei Medusen im Vergleich zu ahnlichen Erscheinungen am Wirbeltierherzen. Zschr. vergl. Physiol., 1936-37, 24: 613-37.—Cardot, H., & Kruta, N. Sur la decoordination de la systole du ventricule ou des coeurs branchiaux isoles de la seiche. C. rend. Soc. biol., 1935, 119: 591-4.—Kawasaki, G., & Ike, T. Zur Frage des Verhaltens der Kammer bei der sogenannten zweiten Stannius'schen Ligatur. Jap. J. M. Sc, 1939-40, 6: Proc. Biophysics, 141—Lloyd, W. Experimental heart block in HEART-BLOCK 247 HEART-BLOCK the rabbit. Heart, Lond., 1929-30, 15: 125-7. Also repr.— Lundy, C. J., & Woodruff, L. W. Experimental heart block. Arch. Int. M, 1929, 43: 184-6.—Lutembacher, R. Conduc- tion transmyocardique; etude experimentale; blocs par stric- ture et alterance. Arch. mal. coeur., 1935, 28: 788-99.— Pi Suffer, A., & Bellido, J. M. Nota sobre la inversio estr6ncica en el bloc experimental. Tr. Soc. biol., Barcel., 1914, 2: 169, 3 pl.—Robb, J. S., Easby, M., & Hiss, J. G. Experi- mental interference with conduction in the heart. Am. J. M. Sc, 1934, 188: 835-42.—Rubino, A. Dimostrazione speri- mentale di blocco di emergenza per arresto dello stimolo aH'uscita dal nodo del seno. Cuore & circol., 1935, 19: 701-7.— Samojlov, A. Die Stromkurve des partiell durchschnittenen Froschventrikels und die Leitung im Herzmuskel. Arch. ges. Physiol., 1929, 222: 516-33. ---- incomplete. Alexander, H. L., & Bauerlein, T. C. The influence of posture on partial heart-block. Am. Heart J., 1936, 11: 223-6.—Allan, G. A. The influence of variations of vagal tone on a case of partial heart-block. Glasgow M. J., 1928, 109: 30-45.—Colvin, L. T. Partial heart block in upper respiratory infection. J. Michigan M. Soc, 1929. 28: 121-3.—Dressier, W. Dissoziationen und Interferenzen bei partiellem Herzblock. Zschr. klin. Med., 1929, 111: 23-47.—Estape, F. de A. Block cardiaco parcial de origen medicamentoso: farmacologfa cUnica de la escila maritima. An. Hosp. S. Cruz, Barcel., 1928, 2: 20-3.—Faulkner, J. M. An extraordinary degree of partial heart-block; report of a case in which the P-R interval exceeded the R-R interval. Am. Heart J., 1934-35, 10: 969-73.—Gosse, A. H. Case of acute partial heart-block. Proc R. Soc. M., Lond., 1913-14, 7: Sect. Dis. Child., 141-4 — Herles, F., & Sirkl, H. [Partial heart-block and Adams- Stokes syndrome without anatomical changes in the atrio- ventricular auricle] Cas. lek. Cesk., 1933, 72: 1342-6.— Kraus. Fall von partiellem Herzblock. Med. Klin., Berl., 1919, 15: 274.—Laufer, S. Ueber Angina pectoris mit Adams- Stokes'schen Anfallen bei einem Fall von partiellem Herzblock. Wien. Arch. inn. Med., 1934, 26: 21-8.—Levy, R. C, Partial heart block due to increased vagus action; a case report. Ann. Int. M., 1938-39, 12: 1525-9.—Lorenz, E. Ueber einen Fall von funktionellem partiellen Herzblock. Zschr. Kinderh., 1927, 43: 552-4.—Meyer, E. Unbestiindiger Herzblock (bloc instable) Zschr. Kreislaufforsch., 1932, 24: 369-74.—Mobitz, W. Ueber den partiellen Herzblock. Zschr. klin. Med., 1928, 107: 449-62.—Pinchin, A. J. S. Variable heart block with cyanosis; ? specific pulmonary arteritis (Ayerza syndrome) or congenital lesion; case for diagnosis. Proc. R. Soc. M., Lond., 1929-30, 23: Sect. Clin., 29-31.—Santucci, G. Su due casi di blocco cardiaco parziale clinostatico. Cuore & circol., 1932, 16: 441-3.—Schmitt, F. O. Conduction in depressed cardiac muscle and its relation to the theory of partial heart block. Am. J. Physiol., 1928, 85: 332-46.—Spangenberg, J. J., Vedoya, R., & Gonzalez Videla, J. Disociaciones e inter- ferencias en los bloqueos parciales; los cambios de forma de los complejos QRS. Rev. argent, card., 1937-38, 4: 411-43 — Tur, A. Ueber einen Fall von sogenanntem unbestandigen Herzblock. Wien. Arch. inn. Med., 1931, 21: 53-78, tab — Wawrzyniak, S., & Hanasz, B. [Clinical and electrocardio- graphic aspect of partial block with Wenckebach's periods] Nowiny lek., 1936, 48: 637-^0.—Wiggs, L. B. Partial heart block. Old Dominion J. M. & S., 1914, 19: 264-7.—Winter- berg, H. Partieller Herzblock. Wien. med. Wschr., 1922, 72: 97.—Zamfir, C, & Ramniceanu, R. Sur la valeur de l'epreuve au nitre d'amyle dans le blocage partiel intermittent. Rev. ?t. med., Bucur., 1939, 28: 1133-7. ------ & Petresco, G. Considerations sur un cas de blocage partiel intermittent chez un adolescent. Bull. Acad. med. Roumanie, 1937, 2: pt 2, 476-81. Also J. Acad. med. Roumanie, 1937, 4: 476-81. ---- intraauricular. Calabresi, M., & Picchini, G. Contributo alia conoscenza dei disturbi di conduzione intraatriale. Cuore & circol., 1931, 15: 542-66, 3 ch.—Falkiewicz, A. Beitrag zur Frage der intraaurikularen Leitungsstorungen beim Menschen; ein Fall von langsamer, cyclischer Formveranderung der P-Zacke im Ekg. beim Sinusrhythmus. Deut. Arch. klin. Med., 1933, 175: 273-80.—Izquierdo, J. J. The influence of sympathetic stimu- lation upon intra-auricular block in the mammalian heart. Am. J. Physiol., 1930, 91: 696-711.—Snellen, A. [The possi- bility of intra-auricular dissociation] Ned. tschr. geneesk., 1935, 79: 1769-71. ---- intraventricular. See also Heart-block, bundle branch. Speckmann, K. D. *Ueber die Lebens- und Berufsaussichten der Herzkranken mit intra- ventrikularen Reizleitungsstorungen [Giessen] 12p. 22cm. Diisseld., 1938. Also Deut. med. Wschr., 1939, 65: 457-9. Bohning, A., Katz, L. N. [et al.] Intraventricular block, including so-called bundle branch block. Am. J. M. Sc, 1941, 202: 671-84.—Bohning, A., Katz, L. N., & Langendorf, R. The distribution of surface potential on the chest in intra- ventricular block. Am. HeartrJ., 1941, 22: 778-93.—Boulanger, P., Huriez, C, & Cuvelier, R. Blocs des branches et arborisa- tion du faisceau; de commande du coeur. Echo med. nord, 1931, 35: 361; 374.—Brinck, J., Misske, B., & Schone, G. Zur Khnik und Pathologie des arborisation block (Astblock) Deut. Arch. klin. Med., 1930, 169: 129-65.—Chini, V. Sui cosidetti blocchi delle arborizzazioni (ricerche sperimentaU sul cuore di conigUo) Rinasc. med., 1928, 5: 432-7, pl.—Churg, J. [Case of latent intraventricular block] Nowiny lek., 1937, 49: 187-91.—Etcheves, J. C. Bloqueo de arborizaeiones. Dfa med., B. Air., 1933-34, 6: 557.—Falkiewicz, A. [Latent dis- orders in intraventricular conductibility] Polskie arch. med. wewn., 1932, 10: 3-9, pl. Also Zschr. Kreislaufforsch., 1932, 24: 713-8.—Fehcr. S., & Freundlich, J. Ueber die Beziehung der intraventrikularen Leitungsstorung zur Starke des Lei- tungsreizes. Deut. Arch. klin. Med., 1932,173:256-62 — Goldenberg, M., Gottdenker, F., & Rothberger, C. J. Ueber Interferenzen im Purkinjefaden und im Sinusknoten. Arch. ges. Physiol., 1936, 237: 423-37.—Hamburger, W. W. Bundle branch block; 4 cases of intraventricular block showing some interesting and unusual cUnical features. Med. Clin. N America, 1929, 13: 343-62.—HUbener, G. Die intraventri- kulare Reizleitungsstorung. Deut. med. Wschr., 1938, 64: 1222.—Kaplan, L. G., & Katz, L. N. The prognosis of intra- ventricular block. Am. Heart J., 1939, 18: 145-9.—Kienle, F. Ueber die Prognose des Verzweigungsblockes. Munch, med. Wschr., 1939, 86: 168-71.—Mahaim, I. Contribution k l'etude des blocs de branches et des blocs ventriculaires. Ann. med., Par., 1927, 22: 213-41. ------ Nouvelles recherches sur les lesions du faisceau de His-Tawara; le bloc bilateral manque; nouveUe forme anatomique de bloc du coeur, k substituer au bloc dit d'arborisations. Ibid., 1932, 32: 347-77. Also C. rend. Soc. biol., 1932, 109: 183-6.—Mentzingen, A. von. Ueber einen Fall von funktionellem Verzweigungsblock. Klin. Wschr., 1934, 13: 1158.—Moia. B., & Inchauspe, L. H. Sobre un caso de P-R corto con QRS ancho y mellado presentando asincronismo ventricular. Rev. argent, card., 1938, 5: 114- 23.—Moore, N. S., & Stewart, H. J. The disappearance of intraventricular heart-block occurring in uremia following the intravenous injection of hypertonic glucose solution. Am. Heart J., 1929-30, 5: 469-76.—Mulder, J. [Functional intra- ventricular block with tachycardia and auricular fibriUation] Ned. tschr. geneesk., 1935, 79: 447-54.—Nieuwenhuizen, C. L. C. van, & Matthijssen, E. [Electrocardiogram in 4 deviations in bundle- and arborization block] Ibid., 1937, 81: 5308-17, 3 pl.—Rothberger, C. J. Beitrag zur Kenntnis der intraventrikularen Leitungsstorungen und zur Theorie des Arborisation Block. Zschr. ges. exp. Med., 1933, 87: 763-76. Also Zschr. Kreislaufforsch., 1935, 27: 346-8.—Samet, B. Zur Kenntnis der intraventrikularen Leitungsstorungen. Wien. Arch. inn. Med., 1927, 14: 15-20.—Sampson, J. J., & Nagle, O. E. The prognosis of bundle branch block and other intraventricular conduction system lesions. Am. J. M. Sc, 1936. 191: 88-97. Also repr.—Scherf, D. Experimentelle und kUnische Untersuchungen uber intraventrikulare Lei- tungsstorungen. Wien. Arch. inn. Med., 1927,14: 443-62, 8 pl. ------ Ueber intraventrikulare Storungen der Erregungs- ausbreitung bei den Wenckebachschen Perioden. Ibid., 1929, 18: 403-16, 2 pl.—Schwab, R. Klinische und elektrokardio- graphische Beobachtungen iiber vorubergehenden Schenkel- und Verzweigungsblock. Deut. Arch. klin. Med., 1937, 180: 664-75.—Wolferth, C. C, & Wood, F. C. Further observa- tions on the mechanism of the production of a short P-R interval in association with prolongation of the QRS complex. Am. Heart J.. 1941, 22: 450-7. ---- Juvenile cases. Funk, G. *Beitrag zur Kenntnis der Ueber- leitungsstorungen am Herzen der Kinder. 12p. 8? Wiirzb., 1928. Lemann, I. I. Heart block in the young. Tr. Ass. Am, Physicians, 1933, 48: 195-205. Also Ann. Int. M., 1933, 7: 779-87.—Pollak, R., & Hecht, A. Ein Fall von Stoning der Reizleitung am Herzen bei einem funfjahrigen Madchen. Mitt. Ges. inn. Med. Kinderh. Wien, 1912, 11: 165-7.— Sprague, H. B., & White, P. D. High-grade heart-block under the age of 30. Med. Clin. N. America, 1927, 10: 1235-50 — Wilkinson, K. D. A case of heart-block at 24 years of age' Birmingham M. Rev., 1911, 70: 217-26, 2 pl. ---- Manifestation. Allan, G. A. Case of paroxysmal tachycardia of ventricular origin with Stokes-Adams syndrome, exhibiting retrograde conduction with partial heart-block. Glasgow M. J., 1926, 105: 440-7, 2 pl.—Boer, S. de. Flimmern der Vorhofe oder der Kammern bei Herzblock. Deut. med. Wschr., 1926, 52: 1945.—Chatel, A. de. Veranderungen des ersten Herztones bei Ueberleitungsstorungen. Klin. Wschr., 1935, 14: 1004-6.— Held, I. W. Heart block (Adams-Stokes syndrome) report of a case. N. York M. J., 1913, 97: 763-6.—Hyman, H. T. Asymptomatic heart block of long duration. J. Am. M. Ass., 1930, 94: 27.—Lutembacher, R. Troubles de conduction transmyocardique; systoles fractionnees et ralentissement uniforme de la conduction. Arch. mal. coeur, 1939, 32: 780-9. ------ Asynchronisme du rel&chement diastoUque. Presse med., 1940, 48: 279.—Ramond, L. A propos d'une dysphasie. Ibid., 1938, 46: 1275.—Schabert, A. Ueber kUnischen Herz- block. Petersb. med. Zschr., 1913, 38: 263-9.—Wilson, F. N., & Robinson, G. C. Heart-block; two cases showing unusual features. Arch. Int. M., 1918, 21: 166-75.—Yague y Espinosa, HEART-BLOCK 24S HEART-BLOCK J. L. Dos casos de sindrome de block enmascarados y con- comitantes con dolencias digestivas. Siglo med., 1926, 77: 237-9.—Zelenine, V. F., & Fogelson, I. I. [Phonogram of the auricles and cannon murmur in heart block affection] Med. biol. J., Leningr., 1926, 2: No. 3, 12-23. ---- paroxysmal, and transient. Andersen. W. T. [Paroxvsmal heart block in a young individual) Ugeskr. laeger, 1938, 100: 250-2.—Carter, E. P., & McKachern, D. Recurrent complete heart-block; report of a case associated with transient bundle-branch block and normal conduction between attacks. Bull. Johns Hopkins Hosp., 1931, 49: 337-55.—Comeau, W. J. Paroxysmal complete heart block alternating with normal rhvthm and conduction. Am. J. M. Sc, 1937, 194: 43-53, pl.—Delius, L. Klinischer Bericht iiber einen FaU von vorubergehendem Herzblock mit iibnormer Kammereigenfrequenz. Deut. Arch. klin. Med., 1934-35, 177: 107-14.—Dubbs. A. W. Intermittent complete heart block; report of a case. Am. Heart J., 1938, 16: 235-9.— Gager. L. T. Intermittent complete heart block: a ease report. Virginia M. Month., 1932, 59: 300-2.—Lyons, R. E., jr. In- termittent complete heart block; report of a case. J. Indiana M. Ass., 1939, 32: 622.—Reid, W. D. Intermittent partial heart block: report of a case. J. Lab. Clin. M., 1927-28, 13: 734-8.—Salzer, M., 0 HEART-BLOCK ---- Stokes-Adams syndrome. See also subheading Syncope; also Heart failure. Barer, L. *Con1ribution k l'etude du syn- drome de Stokes-Adams (pouls lent permanent) 61p. 8? Montp., 1912. Benguiijui, A. *Stokes-Adams paroxystique (bradycardie par dissociation paroxystique) 104p. 8? Par., 1933. Bessard, C. *Deux ens de maladie de Stokes- Adams. 27p. 8? Geneve, 1924. Gonin, A. *Le syndrome dc Morgagni- Adams-Stokes, vertiges et syncopes dans la dissociation auriculo-ventriculaire. 431p. 25^cm. Lyon, 1938. Wulf, G. *Beitrage zum Adams-Stokes'schen Symptomenkomplex. 60p. 8? Konigsb., 1913. Wyxeken', A. F. *Ueber zwei Falle von Morgagni-Adams-Stokes'scher Krankheit. 36p. 8? Lpz.-Reudnitz, 1911. Ascoli, M. Intorno alia malattia di Adams-Stokes; indagini rliniche. Clin. med. ital., 1907, 46: 341-56, ch.—B, R. W. Medical eponym; Adams-Stokes disease. N. England J. M., 1940, 222: 36.—Boer, S. de. Das Stokes-Adamssche Syndrom. Cardiologia, Basel, 1937, 1: 253-63. Also S. Afr. M. J., 1937, 11: 674-8.—Brodski, Y. F. [Adams-Stokes disease] Nov. med., S. Peterb., 1914, 8: 1 29-38.—Broustet, Traissac, F. J., & Saric. Sur un cas de maladie de Stokes-Adams. J. med. Bordeaux. 1935, 112: 336.—Carrion, P. Un caso de sindrome de Stokes-A dams. Rev. clin. Madr., 1910, 4: 176-81.— Charlier. Un cas de maladie de Stokes-Adams chez le cheval. Echo vet., Liege, 1913-14, 42: 431-4.—Coombs, C. An example of the Stokes-Adams syndrome. Bristol Med. Chir. J., 1913, 31: 30-1. Disbrow, G. W. Stokes-Adams syndrome, with report of a case. Hosp. Bull. Univ. Maryland, 1913-14, 9: 5-9.—Dobozy, K. |Case (if Adams-Stokes syndrome] Orv. hetil., 1938, 82: 202. Donzelot, E. Les formes paroxys- t.iques du syndrome d'Adams-Sl.okes. Bull. Soc. med. hop. Paris, 1926, 3. ser., 137-4 1. Emanuel. Stokes Adams syn- drome. Birmingham M. Rev., 1911, 69: 187.—Falconer, A. W. A case of Adams-Stokes syndrome. S. Afr. M. Rec, 1925. 23: 11.—Ferrabouc, L., & Jude, A. Stokes-Adams paroxystique Bull. Soc. med. hop. Paris, 1938, 3. ser., 54: 720-5.—Fischer G. A. Beobachtungen an einem I all von Adams-Stokesscher Erkrankung. Klin. Wschr., 1930, 9: 1681.—Friederwjtzer, H. H. Stokes-Adams syndrome, with atypical preliminary history. Med. Rec, N. Y., 1941, 154: 19.—Gill, J. M., & Gillies, S. A case of syncopal bradycardia. Australas. M. Gaz., 1906, 25: 335.—Gonzalez Sabathie, L. Contribuci6n al estudio del sindrome de Adams-Stokes. In his Temas cardiol B. Air., 1939, 2: 273-93.—Gutmann, C. Ueber einen Eigen- artigen Fall von Adam-Stokesschem Symptomenkomplex Klin. Wschr., 1929, 8: 842.—Hegler. Adams-Stokes'scher Symptomenkomplex. Deut. med. Wschr., 1912, 38: 530.— Heineke, A., Miiller, A., & Hosslin, H. von. Zur Kasuistik des Adams-Stokes'schen Symptomkomplexes und der Ueber- leitungsstorungen. Deut. Arch. klin. Med., 1908, 93: 459-84.— Hekman, J. J. Ecu geval van de ziekte van Stokes-Adam. Wd. tschr. geneesk., 1913, 1: 905-7.—Hijmans van den Bergh, A. A. [A peculiar case of Adams-Stokes syndrome] Ibid 1928, 72: pt 2, 6244-54.—Komeda, M. Ueber einen Fall von Adams-Stokes'scher Symptomenkomplex. Orient. J. Dis Inf., Kyoto, 1927, 2: No. 4, 19.—Lastres, J. B. Sindrome de Adams-Stokes. Rev. med. peru., 1937, 9: 59-67.—Lea, C. E. The Spcns (Stokes-Adams) syndrome. Lancet, Lond., 1913, 2: 1288.— Lian, C. De l'epilepsie cardiaque: discussion. Bull Soc. med. hop. Paris, 1930, 3. ser., 46: 635-40.—McMulleni C. J. Stokes-Adams syndrome. Med. Clin. N. America 1931, 15: 769-72.—M^rch Christensen, A., & Dalgaard, f! [Case of Adams-Stokes' syndrome] Nord. med., 1939, 2: 1733-6.—Nordman. Deux cas de maladie de Stokes-Adams' Loire med., 1911, 30: 289-92.—Olivera, A., & Bramanti Jauregui, R. Contribuci6n al estudio del sindrome de Morgagni- Stokes-Adams. Rev. Circ. med. argent., 1928, 28: 1880-903.— Petronio, S. La forma parossistica della sindrome di Morgagni- Adams-Stokes. Fol. med., Nap., 1932, 18: 1414-24.—Polzer, K. Ueber eine eigenartige Form von Morgagni-Adams- Stokes-Anfallen. Wien. klin. Wschr., 1941, 54: 439.—Purser, C, & Davis, N. J. A case of Stokes-Adams disease of the heart Australas. M. Gaz., 1911, 30: 442.—Rosenthal, H. [Adams- Stokes disease] Przegl. lek., 1914, 53: 113-6.—Scott, D. C. Case of Stokes Adams disease occurring in a soldier. Guy's Hosp. Gaz., Lond., 1921, 35: 28.— Spuhler, O. Zum Sympto- menkomplex Adams-Stokes. Zschr. klin. Med., 1935-36 129- 693-709.—Steiner, W. R. Stokes-Adams disease, with report of 3 cases. Boston M. & S. J., 1906, 155: 135-9.—Strachan, ('. G. Stokes-Adams' disease. Univ. Durham Coll M Gaz' 1914-15. 15: 22-4.—Talley, J. E. Adams-Stokes syndrome' Am. J. Electrother.. 1921, 39: 23.5-8.—Terzani, A. La forma parossistica della sindrome di Morgagni-Adams-Stokes Riv clin. med., 1926, 27: 947-63. -Tomaselli, C. Sopra un caso di morbo di Adam.>-Stokes. Atti Soc. lombard. sc. med 1921. 10: 136-47.-Tnmaszowski, Z. [Adams-Stokes sympto^ mocomplex] Lwow. tygodn. lek., 1911, 6: 237; 218.—Tuley, H. K. The Adams-Stokes syndrome. Kentucky M. J., 1912, 10: 'm)7 11. Vermast, P. F. Over arythmien van het hart, ziekte van Adam-Stokes. Tschr. diergeneesk., 1919, 46: 299-314. Weber, A. Ein Fall von Adams-Stokes'scher Krankheit Zbl. Herz Gefasskr., 1913, 5: 441-3, pl.—Yaveln, G. Y. [Adams-Stokes disease] Tr. Sezda ross. terapevt 1911, 2: 172-9. ---- Stokes-Adams syndrome: Diagnosis. Geraudel, E. Le signe de la contraction auriculaire satellite dans le syndrome d'Adams-Stokes. Arch. mal. cceur, 1930, 23: 18-32. ------ Syndrome paroxystique d'Adams-Stokes par bradyarythmie sinusale; etude eiectrocardiographique pour- suivie pendant 5 ans. Ibid., 1931, 24: 288-304, ch.—Hermann, H., Froment, R„ & Gonin, A. Maladie de Stokes-Adams avec pauses ventriculaires de tres longue duree; etude eiectro- cardiographique et clinique. Ibid., 1937, 30: 753-86.— Kuenen, W. A. [Electrocardiogram in Adams-Stokes syn- drome] Ned. tschr. geneesk., 1929, 73: pt 2, 4302.—Parkinson, J., Papp, C, & Evans, W. The electrocardiogram of the Stokes- Adams attack. Brit. Heart J., 1941, 3: 171-99. — Stokes-Adams syndrome: Etiology. Risi, A. *Ueberleitungsstorungen am Herzen mit Adams-Stokes'schem Symptomenkomplex bei Diphtheric 24p. 8? Basel, 1930. Arrillada, F. C, & Waldorp, C. P. La taquisistolia auricular en el sindrome de Morgagni-Stokes-Adams (una observaci6n) Rev. As. med. argent., 1921, 34: sect, med., 96-102, pl.— Brandenburger, P. Ueber eine besondere Ursache Adams- Stokes'scher Anfalle. Zschr. Kreislaufforsch., 1938, 30: 246- 51.—Cald, A. Sindrome di Morgagni-Adams-Stokes da dis- sociazione atrio-ventricolare completa notevole per l'accessiva raritS, delle contrazioni ventricolari. Cuore & circol., 1937, 21: 307-19, pl.—Castex, M. R., Di Cio, A. V., & Lopez Ramirez, R. Sindrome de Morgani-Adains Stokes provocado por la com- presi6n ocular en una bradicardia permanente. Rev. Soc. med int., B. Air., 1928, 4: 295-310.—Cheer, S. N., & T'ang, T. K. Transient complete heart block with Adams-Stokes attacks and normal auriculo-ventricular conduction between attacks China M. J., 1932, 46: 1081-7, 2 pl.— Curti, O. P. Sindrome de Stokes-Adams-Morgagni, grave, como testimonio de una arritmia sinusal. Sem. med., B. Air., 1927, 34: 667-70.— Estape, F. de A. Bloqueo cardiaco variable e inconstante con sindrome de Morgagni-Adams-Stokes. An. Hosp. S. Cruz, Barcel., 1928, 2: 341-7.------Extrasistoles frustrados y ataques de Morgagni-Adams-Stokes. Ars medica, Barcel., 1930, 6: 18-23.—Faulkner, J. M. Adams-Stokes syndrome in rheumatic fever; report of a case. N. England J. M., 1930, 22: 1252.—Freundlich, J. Durch Kammerflattern ausgelostc Adams-Stokessche Anfalle. Deut. Arch. klin. Med., 1932 173: 617. Also Mitt. Ges. inn. Med. Wien, 1932, 31: 79.— Galli, G. L'arteriosclerosi del cuore; sindrome di Morgagni- Adams-Stokes. Gazz. osp., 1926, 47: 293-7.—Geraudel, E. Un nouveau cas de syndrome d'Adams-Stokes par lesion transverse du ventriculo-necteur, consecutive k une stenose dc son artere. Ann. anat. path., Par., 1929, 6: 1075-87. ----- Etude anatomo-clinique d'un cas de syndrome d'Adams- Stokes; endarterite k tendance obliterante de la coronaire droite et de l'artere du ventriculo-necteur. Arch. mal. coeur, 1931, 24: 605-26. ------& Benard, R. Un troisieme cas de bradyrythmie ventriculaire par stenose de l'artere du ventriculo- necteur (syndrome d'Adams-Stokes) Presse med., 1927, 35: 1129-31— Geraudel, E., Brodin, P. L., & Lereboullet, J. Etude d'un cas de syndrome d'Adams-Stokes mortel; necrose transverse du ventriculo-necteur par endarterite stenosante de son artere. Arch. mal. cceur, 1929, 22: 1-15.—Geraudel, E., & Coelho, E. Etude anatomo-clinique de 2 cas de syndrome d Adams-Stokes. Ibid., 1932, 25: 605-29.—Geraudel, E.. & Gautier, C. Syndrome d'Adams-Stokes par necrose transverse du ventriculo-necteur consecutive k une endarterite obliterante de son artere. Ann. anat. path., Par., 1931, 8: 339-51.— Geraudel, E., & Lereboullet, J. Syndrome d'Adams-Stokes k evolution rapide par thrombose de la coronaire droite et de 1 artere du ventriculo-necteur. Paris med., 1930, 77: 25-9.— Geraudel, E., & Valensi, A. Un cas mortel de syndrome d Adams-Stokes; lesion transverse du ventriculo-necteur; endarterite stenosante de son artere. Ann. med., Par., 1929, 25: 472-88.—Goldberg, J., & Pipsztat, J. [Two cases of Morgagni-Stokes-Adams's disease, one with heart block, the other with block and disturbed function of ventricles and auricles] Gaz lek., Warsz., 1914, 2. ser., 34: 846-50.—Haas, A. K. J. de [Stokes-Adams' disease in a child with congenital heart disease] Ned. tschr. geneesk., 1928, 72: pt 2, 3368-74, 3 ch—Hay, J. Heart-block in its relationship to Stokes- Adams disease. Med. Chron., Manchester, 1906, 44: 371-82.— Heinnchsen, F. [Case of bradycardia with heart-block and Adams-Stokes symptom-complex] Latv. arstu Z., 1928, 208- 10.—Katz, G. I. [Cases of Adams-Stokes disease with longi- t.^I and transverse dissociation of the heart] Odess. med. J., 1929,4:195-8— Kremer. D. N., Belief, S., & Laplace, L., Complete A-V hearUuock with Adams-Stokes syndrome: report of a case with clinical and pathologic findings. Tr. Coll. Physicians Philadelphia, 1936-37, 4: 53.—Kux, E. Myo- carditis gummosa mit Adams-Stokes'schem Svmptomen- komplex und Mesopulmonitis luica. Zschr. Kreislauffors'h., HEART-BLOCK 251 HEART-BLOCK 1932, 24:1-12.—Lavergne, V. de, Morel, & Jochum. Syndrome de Stokes-Adams transitoire, survenu en m§me temps que des accidents seriques, k la convalescence d'un erysipeie de la face. Bull. Soc. med, hop. Paris, 1927, 3. ser., 51:1314-8.—Leobardy, de & Delrous. Sur un cas grave de maladie de Stokes-Adams associee k une maladie de Roger. Arch. mal. cceur, 1939, 32: 87-97.—Lequime, J. Syndrome de Stokes-Adams par brady- cardie sinusale. Ibid., 1934, 27: 297-302.—Mackintosh, A. W., & Falconer, A. W. Observations upon 2 cases of Stokes- Adams syndrome, unassociated with demonstrable delay of impulse transmission. Heart, Lond., 1910-11, 2: 222-9.— Moorehead, M. T. Constant 2:1 heart block with mild Stokes- Adams syndrome. U. S. Veterans Bur. M. Bull., 1928, 4: 526-9, pl.—Morquio, L. Sobre un caso de malformaci6n cardfaca con sindrome de Stokes-Adams y muerte siibita. Arch. lat. amer. pediat., B. Air., 1926, 3. ser., 20: 381-6.— Plehn. Ein Fall von Herzblock mit Adams-Stokesschem Symptomenkomplex. Deut. med. Wschr., 1913, 39: 648 [Discussion] 673.—Ramond, L., Vialard, S., & Albeaux-Fernet, M. Maladie de Stokes-Adams de nature rhumatismale. Bull. Soc. med. hop. Paris, 1935, 3. ser., 51: 160-3. Also J. med. Paris, 1935, 55: 417-9.—Slot, J. A., Soetjahjo, M., & Muller, H. [Adams-Stokes disease in intermittent total asystole] Geneesk. tschr. Ned. Indie, 1937, 77: 810-7, 2 pl.—Tellgmann. Adams-Stokesscher Symptomenkomplex als Folge schwerer toxischer Herzmuskelschwache. Deut. med. Wschr., 1933, 59: 1923.—Trabaud, J. Quelques commentaires nouveaux k propos d'une observation ancienne de maladie de Stokes- Adams traumatique. Rev. prat. mal. pays chauds, 1937, 17: 463-7. ------ & Mudden, I. Maladie de Stokes-Adams s'etant manifestee k l'occasion d'un traumatisme. Ibid., 276- 80.—Yater, W. M., Barrier, C. W., & McNabb, P. E. Acquired heart block with Adams-Stokes attacks dependent upon a congenital anomaly (persistent ostium primum) report of a case with detailed histopathologic study. Ann. Int. M., 1934, 7: 1263-77. --- Stokes-Adams syndrome, juvenile. Faessler, B. *Das Adams-Stokessche Syn- drom im Sauglingsalter [Zurich] p.327-49. 24cm. Basel, 1939. Also Ann. paediat., Basel, 1939, 153: Flesch, A. [Morgagni-Adams-Stokes svndrome in a 1J4 year old child] Orv. hetil., 1936, 80: 806-8. Also Wien. med. Wschr., 1936, 86: 764-6.—Goldenberg, A. G. Le syndrome d'Adams-Stokes k l'&ge infantile. Rev. fr. pediat., 1937, 13: 519-24.—Sperk, B. Ein Fall von Adams-Stokes'schem Symptomenkomplex im Kindesalter. Mitt. Ges. inn. Med. Wien, 1913, 12: 117. --- Stokes-Adams syndrome: Manifestation. Scheffen, H. *Psychosomatische Beobach- tungen bei Kranken mit Adams-Stokes'schem Symptomen-Komplex und Hypertonic 24p. 8: Frankf. a. M., 1930. Arillaga, F. C, & Waldorp, C. P. La taquisistolia auricular en el sindrome de Morgagni-Stokes-Adams. Sem. med., B. Air., 1921, 28: 565.—Bramwell, B. Clinical studies; note on a remarkable (temporary) condition of the pulse in 2 cases of Stokes-Adams' disease with heart-block. Edinburgh M. J., 1915, 14: 168-71.—Castex, M. R., Di Cio, A. V., & L6pez Ramirez, R. Sindromo de Morgagni-Adams Stokes provocado por la compresi6n ocular en una bradicardia permanente. Prensa med. argent., 1928, 15: 373-82.—De Meyer, J. Presen- tation d'un cas de Stokes-Adams (sans symptomes subjectifs) Ann. Soc. sc. med. natur. Bruxelles, 1920, 132.—Formijne, P. KUnische und experimentelle Beobachtungen iiber Atmung und zerebrale Reaktionen beim Herzstillstand. Verh. Deut. Ges. Kreislaufforsch., 1935, 8: 185-92. ------ Apnea or convulsions following standstill of the heart. Am. Heart J., 1938, 15: 129-45.—Frugoni, C. Sindrome di Morgagni Adams- Stokes con assoluto sincronismo cardio-respiratorio. Minerva ..ied., Tor., 1928. 8: 913-25.—Gomez, D. M. La pression arterielle et notamment la pression moyenne dans le syndrome d'Adams-Stokes. Arch. mal. coeur, 1931, 24: 763-7—Hazen- berg, K. The pathological physiology of the syndrome of Morgagni-Adams-Stokes. Acta brevia neerl., 1939, 9:135-7.— Hill, I. G. W., & MacKinnon, A. U. The association of Adams- Stokes attacks with Cheyne-Stokes respiration with a case report. Edinburgh M. J., 1934, r. ser., 41: 513-29.—Langeron, L. Sur les accidents nerveux du syndrome de Stokes-Adams. Vie med., 1931, 12: 1233-44. ------& Bera. Stokes-Adams; tachyauriculie; bradyventriculie; dissociation partielle, puis complete; alterations du complexe coincident avec le Stokes- Adams; stabilisation et tolerance. Arch. mal. cceur, 1930, 23: 145-52.—Leitz, T. F. Report of a case of Adams-Stokes disease (general infection; bradycardia; epileptiform seizures; Cheyne- Stokes respiration; apparent recovery) Maryland M. J., 1907, 50: 345.—Magniel, M. Angine de poitrme et syndrome d'Adams-Stokes. Prat. med. fr., 1928, 7: 46-53.—Michel, M., Poumaillouz, M., & Pierre, F. Syndrome de Stokes-Adams transitoire; pause ventriculaire de 16 secondes enregistree par eiectrocardiogramme. Bull. Soc. med. hop. Paris, 1928, 3. ser., 52: 200-5.—Milew, A. Beitrag zur Klinik des Adams-Stokes. Deut.-Arch. klin. Med., 1933-34, 176: 219-27.—Mozer, J. J. & Duchosal, P. Le galop du block dans la maladie de Stokes- Adams; enregistrements eiectrophonocardiographiques. Arch mal. cceur, 1930, 23: 247-51.—Padilla, T., & Cossio, P. Sin- drome de Stokes-Adams y bradicardias cronotropas. Sem med B. Air., 1929, 36: pt 2, 1041-3.—Perrin, M., & Mathieu, X. Maladie de Stokes-Adams: etude du rythme; pronostic du valentissement des pulsations. C. rend. Soc. med. Nancv 1906-7, 127-31.—Thayer, W. S. Adams-Stokes syndrome! persistent bradycardia, involving both auricles and ventricles; remarkable prolongation of the As-Vs interval. Tr. Ass. Am Physicians, 1915, 30: 63-77. ---- Stokes-Adams syndrome: Pathogenesis. Bacci, V. II complesso sintomatico Morgagni-Adams- Stokes e i rapporti di dipendenza fra bradisfigmia e fenomeni encefalici. Diagnosi, 1931, 11: 157-74.—Calabresi, M. Sulla patogenesi del morbo di Morgagni-Adams-Stokes. Clin. med. ital., 1931, 62: 646-58, 2 diagr.—Condorelli, L. Sulla patogenesi delle crisi di Adams-Stokes durante il blocco parziale. Arch. sc. med., Tor., 1932, 56: 661-96.—Flaum, E., & Klima, R. Ein neurogen ausgeloster Fall von Adams-Stokes. Klin. Wschr., 1932, 11: 1192. ------ Zur neurogenen Form des Adams- Stokesschen Symptomenkomplexes. Wien. Arch. inn. Med., 1932, 23: 223-46.—Geraudel, E. Les conceptions actuelles du syndrome d'Adams-Stokes. Rev. prat. mal. pays chauds, 1927, 7: 376-85. Also Rev. med. cubana, 1928, 39: 978-86. ------ Etude eiectrocardiographique et anatomique d'un cas de syn- drome d'Adams-Stokes. Arch. mal. coeur, 1930, 23: 704-25. ------ & Giroux, R. Le syndrome d'Adams-Stokes et sa pathogenie. Presse med., 1926, 34: 258-61.—Grassberger, A. KUnische, elektrokardiographische und histologische Unter- suchung eines Falles von Adams-Stokesscher Erkrankung. Zschr. klin. Med., 1929-30, 112: 388-413.—Heimann, H. L. The mechanism of the Stokes-Adams syndrome; as illustrated by 3 cases. Lancet, Lond., 1929, 1: 68-71.—Klima. Neurogen ausgeloste Anfalle von Adams-Stokes. Mitt. Ges. inn. Med. Wien, 1932, 31: 12-4.—Langeron, L. Sur le mecanisme des accidents nerveux du Stokes-Adams (d'aptes 3 traces electro- cardiographiques pris en crise) Rev. med., Par., 1931, 48: 483-92. Also Paris med., 1933, 89: 81.—Laufer, S. II sistema neurovegetative nella patogenesi della sindrome di Morgagni- Adams-Stokes. Minerva med., Tor., 1938, 29: pt 2, 16-9.— Mahaim, I. A propos du syndrome d'Adams-Stokes; critique de la nouvelle theorie des cardio-necteurs independants. Presse med., 1926, 34: 1476-8.—Mendonca Castro. Sobre pathogenia do syndrome de Adams-Stokes. Arch, brasil. med., 1928, 18: 617-9.—Papp, C. Sindrome di Adams-Stokes da lipomatosi del nodo Tawara. Policlinico, 1932, 39: sez. med., 253-64.— Parade, G. W., & Voit, K. Zur Pathologie und Therapie der Adams-Stokesschen Krankheit. Deut. med. Wschr., 1931, 57: 629.—Reiniger, A. Die Rolle der Sensibilitatsstorungen im Kehlkopf bei der Entstehung des Adams-Stokesschen Symptom- menkomplexes. Zschr. Hals &c. Heilk., 1932, 31: 531-47 [Dis- cussion] 553.—Schwartz, S. P., & Jezer, A. The Stokes-Adams syndrome; some clinical and graphic observations on the cardiac mechanism underlying syncopal seizures. Med. Clin. N. Ameri- ca, 1933, 17: 213-31.—Vigevani, G. Sulla interpretazione di una sindrome di Adams-Stokes transitoria. Osp. maggiore, Milano, 1911, 6: 197-214.—Yater, W. M., & Willius, F. A. Heart-block showing multiple transitions associated with convulsive syncope; report of a case with detailed histo-patho- Iogical study. Am. Heart J., 1928-29, 4: 280-95. ---- Stokes-Adams syndrome: Treatment. Condorelli, L. Tentativo di terapia in sindrome di Adams- Stokes: ritmo ventricolare artificialmente mantenuto per due ore mediante stimolazioni meccaniche (contributo cUnico) Minerva med., Tor., 1928, 8: pt 2, 343-50.—Crosetti, L. L'efetonina negli accessi di Morgagni-Adams-Stokes. Atti Accad. fisiocr. Siena, 1933, 11. ser., 1:179-81.—G., P. Traite- ment des bradycardies; maladie de Stokes-Adams. Presse med., 1940, 48: 685.—Gerhardt, D. Ueber Ruckbildung des Adams-Stokes'schen Symptomenkomplexes. Deut. Arch. kUn. Med., 1908, 93: 485-99.—Gilchrist, A. R. Ephedrine sulphate and barium chloride in the prevention of Stokes- Adams seizures. Brit. M. J., 1934, 1: 610-3.—Heard, J. D., Marshall, W. R., & Adam, F. S. Heart-block with convulsive syncope; case report and pathological findings in a patient unsuccessfuUy treated with barium chloride. Tr. Ass. Am. Physicians, 1927, 42: 58-65. Also Am. Heart J., 1927, 2: 562-72.—Hecht, A. Elektro-kardiographische Analyse des von Speck demonstrierten FaUes von Adams-Stokes und die darauf gegriindete therapeutische Bee;nflussung der Anfalle. Mitt. Ges. inn. Med. Kinderh. Wien, 1913,12:118.—Herrmann, G. R., & Ashman, R. Heart-block with and without convulsive syncope; spectacular therapeutic results from barium chloride; consideration of the physiological mechanisms involved in the effects of the therapy and in conduction disturbance in general. Am. Heart J., 1925-26, 1: 269-303.—Higley, C. S., & Stecher, R. M. Stokes-Adams disease treated with ephedrine; final report of a case. Ibid., 1933, 9: 90-5.—Hollingsworth, M. Ephedrin in Adams-Stokes syndrome. California West. M., 1927, 26: 802.—Katz, G. I. [Therapeutic problems in Adams- Stokes syndrome] Odess. med. J., 1929, 4: 283.—Levine, S. A. The treatment of the attacks of syncope occurring in Adams- Stokes disease. Boston M. & S. J., 1926, 195: 1147-9. Also Tr. Ass. Am. Physicians, 1926, 41: 67-71. ------& Matton, M. Observations on a case of Adams-Stokes syndrome, show- ing ventricular fibrillation and asystole lasting 5 minutes, with HEART-BLOCK recoverv following the intracardiac injection of adrenalin. Heart, Lond., 1925-26, 12: 271-9.—Lueth, H. C. The use of metrazol in complete heart block with Adams-Stokes syndrome; report of 4 cases. Am. Heart J., 1938, 16: 555-60-M>res, M. J. Stokes-Adams syndrome; report of 2 cases treated with metrazol. South. M. J., 1941, 34: 833-5.—Parade, G. W., \- Voit, K. Zur Adrenalin- und Ephetoninbehandlung der \dams-Stokesschen Krankheit. Deut. med. Wschr., 1929, 55: 179-81.—Parkhurst, G. M. A case of heart block with Stokes-Adams syndrome, treated with barium chloride and digitalis. N. York State J. M., 1930, 30: 79.—Parsonnet, A. E., & Hyman, A. S. Barium chlorid in the Stokes-Adams svndrome of completo heart block; negative results in 8 cases. Am. J. M. Sc. 1930, 180: 356-64, 3 p].—Patrick, A., Chalmers, M., & Crawford, R. M. C. Case of Stokes-Adams svndrome; treatment by adrenalin. Glasgow M. J., 1926. 106: 183.— Polak Daniels. L. Stokes-Adams cerebral manifestations and their treatment. Geneesk. tschr. Ned. Indie, 1938, 78: 1091- S.—Price, F. W., & Nisse, B. S. The treatment of Adams- Stokes syndrome due to auriculoventricular block. Am. Heart J., 1929-30, 5: 197-212.—Roberts, L. J., & Taber, T. H. Ephedrine in the treatment of Adams-Stokes syndrome; report of case. U. S. Nav. M. Bull., 1932, 31: 27-31.— Scherf, D. Der Morgagni-Adams-Stokes-Symptomenkomplex und seine Behandlung. Aerztl. Prax., Wien, 1936, 10: 309. Also Wien. klin. Wschr., 1936, 49: 83.—Seeber, F. Zur Be- handlung des Herzblocks und der Adam-Stokesschen Erkran- kung mit Ephetonin. KUn. Wschr., 1933, 12: 1648-50 — Sigler, L. H. Treatment of the Stokes-Adams syndrome by hypertonic glucose solution given intravenously. Ann. Int. M, 1939-40, 13: 101-6.—Stecher. R. M. A note on Stokes- Adams disease treated with ephedrin. Am. Heart J., 1927-28, 3: 567-73.—Weiss, S., & Ferris, E. B., jr. Adams-Stokes syndrome with transient complete heart block of vagovagal reflex origin; mechanism and treatment. Arch. Int. M., 1934, 54: 931-51.—Wood, J. E. Kphedrine in Adams-Stokes syndrome. J. Am. M. Ass., 1932, 98: 1364-7. Also repr. Also South. M. J., 1932. 25: 927. ---- Syncope, and standstill. See also Heart failure; Heart ventricle, Fail- ure; also in 3. ser. Syncope. Boccia, D. Coma, sfneope v colapso; diagn6stico y trata- miento. Sem. med., B. Air.. 193-1, 41: pt 2, 1707-17.—Borg, J. F., & Johnson. C. E. Cardiac syncope; concerning the clinical differentiation of its types. Am. Heart J., 1937, 13: SH-94.—Bouchet. Asvstolie intermittente sur un cheval. Bull. Acad. v6t. France, 1928, 1: 83 5.—Ferradas. J. B. Sfneope, colapso y coma. Rev. Cfrc. med. argent., 1930, 30: 1628-50.—Gil-Casares, M. Sincope, shock y colapso. Rev. espan. med. cir., 1928, 11: 65-70.—Green, T. M. Cardiac arrest. Ann. Surg., 1930, 92: 331-4.—Horton, B. T., Eaton, L. M.. & Meriwether, L. S. Syncope. Minnesota M., 1938, 21: 628-35.—Jobin, A. De la syncope. Bull. med. Quebec, 1926, 27: 233.—Lorenzo y Deal, J., & Mendoza, G. AsistoUa aguda con dilataci6n cardfaca en un lactante. Arch, pediat. Uruguay, 1938, 9: 220-6.— Lutembacher. R. Etudes sur le coeur arrete. In Libro de oro M. R. Castex, B. Air., 1938, 2: 866-79.—Massie, E. Svncope. In Modem Med. Ther. (Barr, D. P.) Bait., 1940, 3: 2693-5.—Murphy, F. D. Syncope. In Cyclop. Med. (Piersol-Bortz) Phila., 1940, 14: 713-22.— Raimann, E. Ueber synkopale Anfalle. Deut. Zschr. Nervenh., 1928,102:151.—Schloss, S. A. Case report. J. Med., Cincin., 1936-37, 17: 187.—Tesaf, J. [Sudden death caused by asystole] Sborn. 16k., 1939, 41:335-81.—Weiss, S. Syncope and collapse. N. England J. M., 1937, 216: 102. ------ Syncope, coUapse, and shock. Proc. Inst. M. Chicago, 1940-41, 13: 2-12.— Zimmermann-Meinzingen, O. Ein FaU von voriibergehendem HerzstUlstand. Wien. med. Wschr., 1940, 90: 718.—Zwaarde- maker, H-, & Witanowski, W. On the transitory arrest of the heart's action. Proc. Akad. wet. Amsterdam, 1926, 29: pt 2, sect, sc, 761-5, ---- Syncope, and standstill, auricular. Braun, L. Ueber Venenpuls bei Vorhofstillstand. Beibl. Mitt. Ges. inn. Med. Kinderh. Wien, 1909, 8: 3-12.—Frey, W., & Schittenhelm, A. Ventrikelautomatie mit stiUstehenden Vorhofen. Zschr. ges. exp. Med., 1921, 12: 411-17.—Rosen- baum, F. F., & Levine, S. A. Auricular standstill; its occur- rence and significance. Am. J. M. Sc, 1939, 198: 774-8, pl.— Wedd, A. M.. & Wilson, D. C. StandstiU of the heart of vagal origin. Am. Heart J., 1929-30, 5: 493-503. ---- Syncope, and standstill: Death. Jezer, A., Master, A. M., & Schwartz, S. P. Observations on the mechanism of the dying heart in patients with the Adams-Stokes syndrome due to StandstiU of the ventricles. Am. Heart J., 1936, 11: 303-8. Also repr.—Leake, C. D. Cardiac syncope and sudden death. California West. M 1938, 48: 6.—Nathanson, M. If. Pathology and pharmacology <>f cardiac syncope and sudden death. Arch. Int. M., 1936, 58: 685-702.- Palmieri, V. M. La morte per paralisi cardiaca aU'autopsia inedu-o-legale. Riforma med., 1927,43: 129-31.— Sainz Trajo, A. Dos casos de muerte por sincope en nifios. Rev. m6d. veracruz., 1936, 16: 1843.—Strassmann, G.. & Ziemke, E. Agonale Verletzungen der Halswirbelsiiule und dea Kehlkopfgerustes bei naturhchem, plotzhchem Tod infolge V2 HEART-BLOCK Herzlrihmung. Beitr. gerichtl. Med., 1928, 7: 89-93.—Vallcdor, G. La muerte por parrttisis del corazon. Rev. med. contemp,, Madr., 1911, 33: 257. ---- Syncope, and standstill: Electrocardiog- raphy. Bishop, L. F., Bishop. L. F., jr, & Wheeler, L. H. An electrocardiographic examination during an attack of syncope, with unusual findings. Med. J. & Rec, 1930, 132: 7.—Henri- jean & Waucomont. Nouvelles recherches sur l'61ectrocardio- gramme du cceur arr6t6. Bull. Acad. mod. Belgique, 1926, 5. ser., 6: 403-5, pl.— Lian, ('., & Petit, C. De I'importance do l'eiectro-cardiographie dans le diagnostic et le pronostic des syncopes. Presse med., 1926, 31: 353-5.—Lutembacher, R. Eiectrocardiogramme du coeur arrete par le formol et par lo cobalt. Arch. mal. coeur, 1937, 30: 107. Also Presso med., 1937, 45: 1031-4. ---- Syncope, and standstill: Etiology. Macon, M. N. P. Contribution a l'etude dr la syncope et du reflexe oculo-cardiaque chez les enfants. 54p. 8? Par., 1926. Trocme, P. *Etude des accidents syncopaux au cours des arythmies. 168p. 8? Par., 1927. Antonescu. C. V., & Vinti, I. [Adrenalino-chloroform syncope and the vagusl Cluj. med., 1936, 17: 515-8.—Barbier, J. Les syncopes par evocation genitale. J. m6d. Lyon, 1940, 21: 277-81.—Bardier, E., Soula C, & Stilmunkes, A. Pneumo- gastrique et syncope adrenaUno-chloroformique. C. rend. Soc. biol., 1928, 98: 191-3.—Bouckaert, J. J., & Heymans, C. Syncope adrenalino-chloroformiquc et sinus carotidiens. Ibid., 1930, 105: 878-80.—Donzelot, E. Les syncopes des bradycardiques. Prat. med. fr., 1928, 7: 15-7.—Dumas, A., & Benoit. Syncopes par rythme couple transitoire. Lvon med., 1934, 153: 87-9.—Ferris, E. B., jr, Capps, R. B., & Weiss, S. Carotid sinus syncope and its bearing on the mechanism of the unconscious state and convulsions; a study of 32 additional cases. Medicine, Bait., 1935, 14: 377-456.—Froment, R., & Gonin, A. Les syncopes du bloc auriculo-ventriculaire; considerations sur leur scineiologie et leur pathogenie. Paris m6d., 1938, 107: 375-80.—Gallavardin, L. Syncopes d'origine cardiaque. Prat. med. fr., 1929, 8: 3-6.------ Les syncopes d'effort. Lyon med., 1933, 151: 217-25. ------ Trois nouvelles observations de syncopes d'effort. Ibid., 152: 581-5.------ Svncopes d'origine ind6tcnnin6e. J. med. Lyon, 1935, 16: 567-78.—Gertz, G.. Kaplan, H. A. [et al.j Cardiac syncope due to paroxysms of ventricular flutter, fibrillation, and asystole in a patient with varying degrees of A-V block and intraventricular block; report of case. Am. Heart J., 1938, 16: 225-34.—Gutmann, R. A. A propos des syncopes chez les malades digestifs. Bull. Soc. med. hop. Paris, 1935, 3. ser., 52: 228.—Hermann, H., Portes, F., & Jourdan, F. Syncopes adrenalino-mono-, di-, et tetrachloro- methaniques. C. rend. Soc. biol., 1931, 107: 1541.—Iglauer, S., & Schwartz, B. A. Heart-block periodically induced by the swallowing of food in a patient with cardiospasm (vasovagal syncope) Ann. Otol. Rhinol., 1936, 45: 875-80.— Jarisch, A. Vagovasale Synkope. Zschr. Kreislaufforsch., 1941, 33: 267-79.—Kirklin, O. L. Obstruction of the right innominate and left subclavian arteries with orthostatic syncope. Proc. Mayo Clin., 1935, 10: 673-5.—Kiss, P. [Syncope in childhood] Gy6gydszat, 1937,77:97; 118. Also Arch. Kinderh., 1937,111: 212-23.—La Barre, J. Existe-t-il une syncope 6phedrino- chloroformique? C. rend. Soc. biol., 1928, 98: 863-6.— Lewis, T. Vasovagal syncope and the carotid sinus mechanism, with comments on Gowers' and Nothnagel's syndrome; the Mary Scott Newbold lecture. Tr. Coll. Physicians Phuadel- phia, 1931, 53: 132-43. Also Brit. M. J., 1932, 1: 873-6 — Lian, C. De l'origine vasculaire de certaines syncopes. Bull. Soc. med. hop. Paris, 1930, 3. ser., 46: 1205. ------& Deparis, M. Deux syncopes avec fibrillation ventriculaire transitoire dans un pouls lent permanent par dissociation auriculo- ventriculaire complete. Ibid., 1934, 3. ser., 50: 569-75.— Lukl, P. [Observation on 2 cases of cardiac syncope] Cas. lek. eesk., 1937, 76: 780-2, 5 pl.—Masson, L. Quatre scenes d 6vanouissement. Aesculape, Par., 1935, 25: 98-101 — Papilian, V., Cosma, I., & Russu, I. G. Recherches experi- mentales sur la syncope adrenalino-chloroformique. C. rend. Soc biol., 1934, 115: 311.—Parker, R. L., & Willius, F. A. Cardiac cUnics; clinics on recurrent syncopal attacks with complete heart block. Proc. Mayo CUn., 1938, 13: 797-800. -——- Recurrent syncopal attacks with complete heart block. In Card. CUnics (WiUius, F. A.) S. Louis, 1941, 185-8.— Patricelli, L. Cause of syncope in patients with hypersensitive carotid sinus; report of a case. Northwest M., 1938, 37: 290-4.—Perard. Syncope par compression du bulbe caro- tidien. BuU. Soc. chir. Paris, 1932, 24: 91-3.—Roskam, J. Un syndrome nouveau; syncopes cardiaques graves et syncopes repetees par hyperr6flectivite sino-carotidienne. Presse med., 1930, 38: 590.—Schwartz, S. P. Transient ventricular fibrilla- tion; a study of the electrocardiograms obtained from a patient with auriculoventricular dissociation and recurrent syncopal attacks. Arch. Int. M., 1932, 49: 282-302. Also repr. ----- & Hauswirth, L. Studies on transient ventricular fibriUation; observations on the alterations in the rhythm of the heart preceding syncopal seizures in a woman with transient auriculo- ventricular dissociation. Am. J. M. Sc, 1934, 187: 478-88. — HEART-BLOCK 253 HEART-BLOCK Smith, H. L., & Moersch, F. P. Syncope of patients with hypersensitive carotid reflexes: attacks reproduced by cardiac standstill induced by pressure on carotid sinus. Proc. Mayo CUn., 1935, 10: 401-5.—Spota, B. B. Sfneope cardiaco; accidente de trabajo; informe medico-legal. Prensa med. argent., 1940, 27: 102-6.—Tournade, A., & Malmejac, J. Au sujet de la syncope nicotino-chloroformique et de son mecanisme. C. rend. Soc. biol., 1928, 99: 156. ------ & Morall, A. Syncope hordenino-chloroformique. Ibid., 1931, 106: 532.—Tournade, A., Senevet, G., & Malmejac, J. La syncope lobeUno-chloroformique; les causes ptesumees de son inconstance. Ibid., 1928, 98: 560-2.—Velluda, C. C, & Russu, I. G. Le blocage du systeme reticuloendothelial et la syncope adi-enalino-chloroformique. Ibid., 1935, 120: 57.------ [Retarded adrenalino-chloroform syncope] Cluj. med., 1936, 17: 74—7.—Wedd, A. M. Syncopal attacks related to disorders of cardiac mechanism. Clifton M. Bull., 1931, 17: 45-56. ■----- Syncopal attacks associated with partial heart block. Ibid., 1936, 20: 1-7.—Wells, J. P. Two cases of fatal syncope due to injudicious eating. CUn. J., Lond., 1925, 54: 567.— Willius, F. A. Clinic on recurrent syncope, fracture of the skull and complete heart block. Proc. Mayo CUn., 1937, 12: 355-9. --- Syncope, and standstill, experimental. Gocke, F. *Ueber die Aufhebung des Lentin- stillstandes am Froschherzen durch Tyramin [Minister] 15p. 21cm. Bielefeld, 1936. Bruns, O. Experimentos sobre la manera de hacer frente a la pardUsis cardiaca y respiratoria. Rev. med. Hamburgo, 1927, 8: 247-50.—Cardot, H., Chevallier, A., Faye, F. In- fluence de la lumiere sur l'arrgt du cceur par privation de potassium. C. rend. Soc. biol., 1930, 103: 253.—Chakhotine, S. Suppression de la fonction du coeur de la daphnie par la micro- puncture ultraviolette. Ibid., 1935, 119: 1392.—Clark, A. J., Gaddie, R., & Stewart, C. P. Asphyxial arrest of the isolated frog's ventricle. J. Physiol., Lond., 1934, 82: 265-77.— Ishihama, F. Ueber den plotzlichen und aUmahUchen Warme- stillstand der einzelnen Abteilungen des Froschherzens. Arch. ges. Physiol., 1926, 211: 213-23. ------ Der plotzliche und allmahUche StiUstand am Froschherzen durch Kaltewirkung. Ibid., 224-7.—Kisch, B. Differenzierende Wirkungsanalysen von Herzgiften; zur Kenntnis des sogenannten Kaliparadoxons und des KalistiUstandes des Herzens. Arch. exp. Path., Lpz., 1927, 122: 257-83.—Levi, A. Soprawivenza del cuore al dissanguamento nei conigli sani e digitaUzzati. Boll. Soc. med. chir. Modena, 1926, 27: No. 2, 69-72.—Mangold, E. Die reversible Warmelahmung des Saugerherzens. Klin. Wschr., 1928, 7: 168.—Meltzer, H. Die reversible Warmelahmung des Saugerherzens. Verh. Deut. Ges. Kreislaufforsch., 1928, 196-202. ------ & Mononobe, K. Reversibler Warmestill- stand des isoUerten Warmbluterherzens. Arch. ges. Physiol., 1928, 219: 286-300. ------ Die Warmestarre beim Warm- bluterherzen. Ibid., 301-5.—Soler, F. L., & Gonzalez, J. M. E. El sincope bianco; primeras experiencias en perros, tendientes a aclarar su genesis. Prensa med. argent., 1937, 24: 1555-63.— Thorner, M. W. Recovery of the heart beat of Fundulus embryos after stoppage by potassium chloride. Biol. Bull., 1929, 56: 157-63.—Wagner, R., & Schutz, F. Ueber die Wirkung des Akzelerans auf das warmegelahmte Kaltbliiter- herz. Zschr. Biol., 1928-29, 88: 183-206.— Zwaardemaker, H. Das Erwachen eines Froschherzens nach Kaliumentziehung durch Poloniumstrahlung. Arch. ges. Physiol., 1926, 213: 757-65. ------ Ueber das Erwachen des durch Kalium- entziehung zur Ruhe gekommenen Herzens durch die Beta- strahlung des Radiums. Ibid., 1926-27, 215: 460-7. --- Syncope, and standstill: Physiopathology. Hazin, S. *Angor syncopal a repetition. 88p. 24cm. Par., 1939. Hermabessiere, O. *La syncope; etude pathogenique; r61e de la circulation de retour. 47p. 8? Par., 1931. Battro, A. Lipotimia y sincope. In Bibl. ter. Ter. clin. (Cardini, C, & Beretervide, J. J.) B. Air., 1941, 1: 489-99 — Halbron, P., Lenormand, J., & Poncet, G. Angor syncope k repetition. Paris m6d., 1937, 105: 269-73.—Laubry, C, & Tzanck, A. Du mecanisme de la syncope; role de la circulation de retour. BuU. Soc. med. hop. Paris, 1930, 3. ser., 46:1118- 20.—Mayerson, H. S., & Burch, G. E. Relationships of tissue (subcutaneous and intramuscular) and venous pressures to syncope induced in man by gravity. Am. J. Physiol., 1939-40, 128: 258-69.—Robinson, L. J. Venous blood pressure measure- ments during syncope caused by a hyperirritable carotid sinus reflex. Am. J. M. Sc, 1939, 197: 100-2.—Schwartz, S. P., & lexer, A. Transient ventricular fibrillation; the clinical and electrocardiographic manifestations of the syncopal seizures in a patient with auriculoventricular dissociation. Arch. Int. M., 1932, 50: 450-69.—Starr, I., jr, & Collins, L. H., jr. Physi- ological studies of faintness and syncope. J. Clin. Invest., 1930-31, 9: 561-76.—Symptoms of cardiac standstiU. Brit. M. J., 1938, 2: 132.—Thomas, H. M., jr. Theleffect of ventric- ular asystole on respiration. Tr. Ass. Am. Physicians, 1936, 51: 307-21. Also Bull. Johns Hopkins Hosp., 1936, 59: 213- 30.—Tocantins, L. M. Blood pressure in syncope. Med. J. & Rec, 1930, 131: 350. Also repr. ---- Syncope, and standstill: Resuscitation. Pichereau, R. Y. Contribution k l'etude des methodes de ^animation du coeur. 31p. 24cm. Par., 1939. Adams, H. D., & Hand, L. V. Twenty minute cardiac arrest with complete recovery; principles of prevention and treatment. J. Am. M. Ass., 1942, 118: 133-5.—Bardier, E. Les syncopes cardiaques et l'adrenaline. BruxeUes med., 1927-28, 8: 1242; 1928-29, 9: Suppl., 89.—Beck, C. S. Re- suscitation for cardiac standstiU and ventricular fibrillation occurring during operation. Am. J. Surg., 1941, 54: 273-9.— Bouchet, L., & Paupert-Ravault, P. Les doses massives et prolongees d'ouabaine dans le traitement de l'asystolie. Lyon med., 1925, 137: 103-7.—Bruns, O. Untersuchungen uber die Beseitigung des Herzstillstandes. Verh. Deut. Ges. inn. Med., 1927, 39. Kongr., 120-4.------Untersuchungen iiber die Beseitigung des Herz- und Atemstillstandes. Tungchi med. _ Mschr., 1927-28, 3: 364-71.—Dautrebande, L.. & Charlier, R. Action empechante du nitrite d'amyle et de la cafeine pour la syncope adrenalino-chloroformique et la syncope adrenalino-benzoUque. C. rend. Soc. biol., 1939, 132: 292-6.— Desmarest, E., Lhermitte, J., & Jacquot, G. A propos de la reanimation du coeur dans les svneopes anesthesiques. Anes- thesie, Par., 1939, 5: 481-502 [Discussion] 567.—Electric shocks snap hearts out of fatal twittering. Science News Lett., 1940, 37: 330.—Ferrand. Des injections hypodermiques de morphine, en cas de menaces de mort (syncope ou asphyxie) Bull. Acad, med., Par., 1899, 3. ser., 41: 134-43.—Fischer, H. KompUkationen bei der Wiederbelebung des Herzens. KUn, Wschr., 1926, 5: 1441.—Guerard, J. Therapeutique de la syncope. Bull. med. Quebec, 1926, 27: 235-7.—Herlitzka, A. Soprawivenza e riviviscenza. Rev. sudamer. endoer., B. Air., 1927, 10: 739-57.—Kagan, S. R. The treatment of syncope. Med. Herald, 1926, 45: 156-8. Also repr.—Kartal, S. Herz- stillstand und Coramintherapie. Schweiz. med. Wschr., 1936, 66: 765.—Katz, G. I., & Leibenson, E. A. [Experimental data on resuscitation of the heart] Odess. med. J., 1928, 3: 407.—Kountz, W. B. Revival of human hearts. Ann. Int. M., 1936-37, 10: 330-6.—Lemaire, A. Traitement de la syn- cope. In Ther. med. (Loeper, M.) Par., 1933, 6: 100-28.— Liqueurs stimulantes pour les cas de syncope. Ann. pharm., Louvain, 1906, 12: 202-4.—Markowitz, J., & Mann, F. C. The physiology of cardiac resuscitation. Surg. Clin. N America, 1929, 9: 823-8.—Mauderer. Versuche zur Prophy- laxe und Therapie des akuten Herztodes des Schweines. In Was gibt es Neues (Puttkammer, V.) Hannover, 1938, 233-5.— Morawitz, P. Zur Prophylaxe des akuten Herztodes. Verh. Deut. Ges. inn. Med., 1929, 41. Kongr., 351.—Nathanson, M. H. Further observations on the effect of drugs on induced cardiac standstill; effect of epinephrine and related compounds. Arch. Int. M., 1934, 54: 111-30. ------ Action of para- hydroxyphenylisopropylamine on induced cardiac standstill Proc. Soc. Exp. Biol., N. Y., 1936-37, 35: 627-31.—Robinson, L. J. Benzedrine sulfate in the treatment of syncope due to a hyperactive carotid sinus reflex; report of 2 cases. N. England J. M., 1937, 217: 952.—Schott, E. Ueber isoUertes Schlagen (Wiederbelebung) des rechten Saugetierherzens und das dabei entstehende Elektrokardiogramm. Deut. Arch. klin. Med., 1926, 153: 239-50. ------ Die partielle Wiederbelebung des Herzens durch Sauerstoff. Verh. Deut. Ges. inn. Med., 1927, 39. Kongr., 124-9.—Strauss, S., & Meyer, J. The treatment of transient ventricular standstiU with barium chloride. Am. Heart J., 1927-28, 3: 328-45.—Tetreault, A. La syncope et son traitement. Union med. Canada, 1932, 61: 1139.— Torresini, G. Ricerche sperimentaU suUa rianimazione del cuore. Lav. Lab. fisiol. Univ. Padova, 1937, 24: No. 28, 3-8 — Weis, C. R. Postural hypotension with syncope; report of a case cured with ephedrine sulphate. Ann. Int. M., 1934-35, 8: 920-2.—Weiss, S., & Wilkins, R. W. Syncope, collapse and shock: their medical significance and their treatment. Med. Clin. N. America, 1937, 21:481-510.—Zwaardemaker, H., & Feenstra, T. P. The revival of the heart by means of soft Rontgenrays, after its arrest through the removal of its diffusi- ble potassium. Proc. Akad. wet. Amsterdam, 1929, 32: pt 2, Sect. Sc, 1303, pl. ----— Die Wiederbelebung des Herzens mittels weicher Rontgenstrahlen, nachdem es durch die Ent- fernung seiner permeablen Kaliumsalze zum StiUstand ge- bracht worden war. Strahlentherapie, 1930, 36: 368. Syncope, and standstill: Resuscitation: Intracardiac injection. See also Heart, Injection. Kahane, H. *A propos des injections intra- cardiaques: l'injection intracardiaque d'ouabaine. 48p. 8? Par., 1936. Americano do Brasil, J. Injeccao intracardiaca de adrena- lina. Fol. med., Rio, 1924, 5: 205.—Baillat, G. La cardio- centese reanimante. Gaz. hop., 1927, 100: 845-8. -—;--- Gravissima sincope da narcosi superata con doppia iniezione intracardiaca di adrenalina. Policlinico, 1930, 37: sez. prat., 1552.—Barilari, D. El masaje del corazon, por aspiraci6n e inyecci6n ritmica repetida de la sangre en cavidad cardiaca, como metodo de revivification. Sem. med., B. Air., 1928, 35: pt 2, 1139-42.—Bayma, F. Da reviviscencia do coracao pela injeccao intra-cardiaca medicamentosa. Bol. Soc. med. cir. S. HEART-BLOCK 254 HEART-BLOCK Paulo, 1924-25, 3. ser., 7: 67-77.—Bloch, R. Cu. rison d'une syncope anesth6sique par l'injection intranirliidienne de cafeine apres echec de 1'adrenaline intracardiac pie. l'irs.-e med., 1929, 108.—Bolton, N. H. Recovery after intracardiac injection of ether. Brit. M. J., 1926, 2: 482. Buzi, K. 1'n caso di rianimazione del cuore coll'iniezione intracardiaca di adrenalina. Policlinico, 192ii, 33: sez. prat., 1317-9.—Cam- peanu, L. Contributo alio studio per la rianimazione del cuore. Gior. ital. anest., 1936, 2: 471-3.—Cattell, R. B. The intra- cardiac injection of epineplu ine in cardiac syncope. Surg. Clin. N. America, 1929, 9: 1341-4.—Clerc, A., Zadoc-Kahn, B., & Hertz. Sur la reanimation du cceur humain par les injections intracardiaques d'adrenaline specialement au cours de accidents li6s au syndrome d'Adams-Stokes. Bull. Soc. med. hop. Paris, 1934, 3. ser., 40: 844-57.—Collina, G. Sulle iniezioni intra- cardiache di adrenalina (rivista sintefica) Gior. med. prat., 1927, 9: 105; 116.—Corin, J. Syncope cardiaque chez un pleuretique; reanimation du cceur par l'injection intracardiaque d'adrenaline. Ann. Soc. med. chir. Liege, 1928-29, 62: 9-15 — D'Allaines. Double syncope au cours d'une operation traite nvec succes par l'injection intracardiaque d'adrenaline. Bull. Soc. nat. chir., Par., 1926, 52: 1133-42.—Danielopolu, D., & Marcou, I. Sur la reanimation du cceur par l'injection intra- cardiaque d'adrenaline; procede de l'atropine-adrenaline-stro- phantine-massage. Presse med., 1940, 48: 44—7.—Domenico, R. Rianimazione del cuore mediante iniezione intracardiaca di adrenalina in un caso di morte apparente per alcoolismo acuto. Gazz. osp., 1938, 59: 287.—Fasano, M. Ulteriore contributo alia iniezione intracardiaca di adrenalina. Minerva med., Tor., 1927, 7: 691-4.—Fischer, H. Zur Herz wiederbelebung. Arch. klin. Chir., 1927, 146: 550-61.—Frizzera, A. L'iniezione intra- cardiaca di adrenalina nella sincope operatoria. Boll. med. trent., 1927, 42: 34-6. Also Policlinico, 1927, 34: sez. prat., 45-8.—Garrelon, L., & Pascalis, G. Pourquoi l'on court un danger mortel k pratiquer des injections intra-cardiaques d'adrenaline dans les syncopes chloroformiques secondaires et comment on peut porter secours k ceux qui en sont les victimes. Presse med., 1930, 38: 649-51.—Gohrbandt, E. Intrakardiale Injektionen. Deut. Zschr. Chir., 1927, 205: 28-57.—Graziani, F. Rianimazione del cuore mediante iniezione intracardiaca. Policlinico, 1927, 34: sez. prat., 49.—Grynberg, N. [Intra- cardiac injections of epinephrine] Polska gaz. lek., 1929, 8: 85.—Hoppe, V. [Resuscitation as result of intracardiac injec- tion of adrenalin] Bratisl. lek. listy, 1927-28, 7: 464-8 — Hyman, A. S. Resuscitation of the stopped heart by intracar- diac therapy. Arch. Int. M., 1930, 46: 553; 1932, 50: 283. Also repr.—Iwasaki, H. Ueber das Elektrokardiogramm bei laiicsamem Herztod; Wirkungsmechanismus der intrakar- dialen Injektion von Adrenalin und Vitacampher bei Ster- benden. Klin. Wschr., 1935, 14: 1397-400.—Khlusevich, A. I. [Case of intracardiac injection of adrenalin during syncope] J. ushn. nosov. gorlov. bolez., 1939, 16: 456.—Kiss, P. Ueber die Wirkung des intrakardial zugefuhrten Nebennieren- rindenhormons auf das menschliche Herz. Zschr. ges. exp. Med., 1933, 90: 669-75.—Kogen, A. L. [On epinephrine injections into the heart] Vrach. delo, 1929, 12: 514-7.— Krantzfeld, I. [Current views on methods of resuscitating the heart: intra- cardiac injections] Klin, med., Moskva, 1927, 5: 808-13.— Leopold-Levi. Les injections intracardiaques d'adtenaUne. Clinique, Par., 1928, 23: 296.—Lepoutre. C. Traitement des syncopes anesthesiques par les injections intracardiaques d'adtenaUne. J. sc. med. Lille, 1927, 45: 197-201.—Lian, C, & Deparis, M. Syncope avec arret ventriculaire au cours d'une fibrillation auriculaire; injection intracardiaque d'adrenaline suivie de reanimation du cceur. Bull. Soc. med. hop. Paris, 1934, 3. ser., 50: 565-9.—Lian, C, & Facquet, J. Injections intra-cardiaques d'adrenaline dans les syncopes du pouls lent permanent. Hopital, 1935, 23: 229.—Loreti, M. Della cardiocentesi rianimante (studio sperimentale) Gior. clin. med., 1926, 7: 698-705.—Lucherini, T. Rianimazione del cuore con iniezione intracardiaca di adrenalina in un caso di sincope da puntura del polmone. Riv. osp., 1925, 15: 711-5.— Lunedei, A. Su la dose intracardiaca di adrenalina: cosa pud dedursi dalle prove farmacodinamiche. Riv. clin. med., 1926, 27: 623-35.—Mallardo, C. A. Riviviscenza del cuore con la terapia intracardiaca. Morgagni, 1931, 73: 951.—Manfredi, L. L'iniezione intracardiaca di adrenalina. Arch, biol., Genova, 1926, 3: No. 4, 3-14.—Mayer, A. Reapparition des contrac- tions des oreilletes du cceur au moyen d'injections intra-cardia- ques et intrapericardiques d'oxygene et d'ozone. Bull. Acad. med., Par., 1937, 3. ser., 117: 504.—Micheli, C. A proposito delle iniezioni intracardiache di adrenalina nelle sincopi da anestesia. Umbria med., 1927, 7: 1264-6.—Mikhelson, A. I. [Intracardiac injections of epinephrine in asystole of heart during operations] Vrach. gaz., 1931, 35: 50.—Mourek, J. [Asystole of the heart and intracardiac injections] Cas. lek eesk., 1932, 71: 461-3.—Nikiforov, M. [Case of resuscitation after a long stoppage of the heart by injection of adrenalin into cardiac muscle] Vest, khir., 1927, 11: No. 31, 89-93.—Nordens- toft, J. [Resuscitation of the heart by adrenalin injections] Ugeskr. laeger, 1928, 90: 741-5.—Nuzzi, O. La cardiocentesi rianimante; studio sperimentale sulla iniezione intracardiaca Riforma med., 1926, 42: 75-81.—Paoli, J., Salen, G., & Imbert' R. Syncope cardiaque au cours d'une rachianesthesie traitee avec succes par l'injection intracardiaque d'adrenaUne; con- statations physiologiques. Bull. Soc. nat. chir., Par., 1928, 54: 1325-8.—Paraf, J. L'injection intracardiaque d'ouabaine comme traitement de la syncope mortelle. Bull. Soc. med. hop. Paris, 1935, 3. ser., 51: 852.—Rigano-Irrera, D. L'iniezione intracardiaca di adrenalina nell'arresto del cuore agisce con variazioni del rapporto calcio-potassico? In Scritti in onore di E. Burci, Nap., 1930, 9: 607-14.—Ronzini. M. Contributo alio studio della rianimazione del cuore e del respiro nei gravi accidenti da narcosi: ricerche sperimentali sopra una nuove iniezione intracardiaca. Arch. Soc. ital. chir. Roma (1927) 1928, 34: p. lvii-lix. Also Policlinico, 1928, 35: sez. chir., 90-116.—Roume. A propos des injections intra- cardiaques d'adrenaline (3 observations) Bull. Soc. obst. gyn. Paris, 1927, 16: 475-7.—Royo-Villanova y Morales, R. El tratamiento de la muerte aparente: la resiirrecc ion del coraz6n por la inyecci6n intracardiaca de adrenalina y su valor medico- legal. Siglo med., 1928, 82:497-505. Russo, V. Rianimazione del cuore a mezzo di iniezione intracardiaca di adrenalina. Riv. med., 1927, 35: 180-2.—Sarmiento, P. Le iniezioni intra- aortiche. Cuore £cm. Konigsb., 1937. Addarii, F., & De Marchi, G. Pharmakologische Unter- suchungen am Purkinjefaden. Cardiologia, Basel, 1938 2- 329-54.—Anichkov, S. V. [Ueber die Wirkung der vago- und sympatikotropen Gifte auf verschiedene Herzknotenl J Physiol. USSR, 1934, 17: 318-29. Also Arch, exp Path ' Berl.. 1934-35, 177: 260-71.—Beccari, L. Sulla fisiologia del centri intracardiac!; comunicazione IV: azione della nicotina sul centro atrioventricolare isolato. Mem. Accad. sc. 1st. Bologna, 1926-27, 8. ser., 4: 89-91.—Borisova, E. I., & Rusinov, V. S. [Effect of potassium chloride on the pacemaker of the frog heart] Biull. eksp. biol. med., 1941. 11: 88-91.—Ishihara, M., & Pick, E. P. Zur Pha makologie der Purkinjeschen Faden. J. Pharm. Exp. Ther., 19f6, 29: 355-72.—Kitagawa, C. Ueber die Einfliisse der verschiedenen Herzmittel auf die Erholung der sinoaurikularen Reizleitung; Durchstromungsversuche am Krotenherzen; Kampher-, Vitakampher- und Coffeinwirkung Jap. J. M. Sc, 1938, 5: Proc Biophysics, 118.—Kitagawa. H. Ueber die Einfliisse der verschiedenen Herzmittel auf die Erholung der sino-aurikuliiren Reizleitung; Durchstromungs- versuche am Krotenherzen; Cardiazol-, Hexeton- und Spartein- wirkung. Ibid., 1939-40, 6: Proc. Biophysics, 111-3.— Nenadovics, L. Ueber die Beeinflussung des Reizleitungssys- tems des Herzens durch das naturliche Kohlensaurebad mit indirekter Abkiihlung. Munch, med. Wschr., 1912, 59:2104-7 — Rijlant, P. Contributions k l'etude de l'automatisme et de la conduction dans le coeur; action du pneumogastrique et de ('acetylcholine sur la conduction intra-auriculaire; blocs par com- pression. Arch, internat. physiol., Liege, 1926, 27: 304-36.— Sasaki, M. Ueber die Einfliisse der verschiedenen Mittel auf die Erholung der atrioventrikularen Reizleitung des Krotenherzens (Durchstromungsversuch) Cardiazol-, Kampher- und Hexeton- wirkung. Jap. J. M. Sc, 1938,5: Proc Biophysics, 119.—Seliskar, A. The action of ions upon intra-auricular conduction in the tortoise. J. Physiol., Lond., 1926-27, 61: 172-84.—Trusse- witsch, B. I. Einfluss des Chinins auf verschiedene Herz- knoten. Zschr. ges. exp. Med., 1932-33, 85: 301-6.—Wiggers, C. J., & Garcia Banus, M. The effects of CO2 and fixed-acid acidosis on conduction in the mammalian heart. Am. J. Physiol., 1929, 90: 218-29. ---- Physiology. Boer, S. de [Some new facts on cardiac physiology obtained during examination of the turtle heart and the mussel heart] Ned. tschr. geneesk., 1929, 73: 753-62.—Demoor, J., & Rylant, P. Contributions k la physiologie generale du cceur; le reglage humoral de l'excitabilite et de la contractilite du coeur etudie par la chronaxie. Arch, internat. physiol., Liege, 1930, 32: 80-113.—Inada, S. Beitrag zur Physiologie des cardialen Reizleitungssystems (Untersuchungen am Rinderherzen) Fukuoka acta med., 1936, 29: 22-7.—Izquierdo, J. J. The influence of excision and treatment with saline on the pace- maker of the frog's heart. J. Physiol., Lond., 1929-30, 48: 363-74.—Lyons, A. L. Ueber die Ruckleitung der Erregung von der Kammer auf den Vorhof des Katzenherzens bei hoheren Reizfrequenzen und ihre Beeinflussung durch Kohlensaure. Zschr. ges. exp. Med., 1931, 79: 673-86.—Nordmann, M., & Ruther, A. Ueber die Schlagtatigkeit des explantierten Herz- muskels von Huhn und Ratte und ihre Beziehung zum Reiz- leitungssystem. Arch. exp. Zellforsch., 1931, 11: 315-38.— Postma, N., Teunissen, R. J. H., & Vries, W. de. Ueber die Koordination beim Herzen einiger Teleostier. Acta brevia neerl., 1938, 8: 163-6.—Rijlant, P. L'oscillogramme cathodique de l'activite du faisceau de His et du noeud de Tawara dans le cceur in situ. Sunti Congr. internaz. fisiol., 1932, 14. Congr., 219.—Rothberger, C. J. Beitrage zur normalen und pathologi- schen Physiologie der spezifischen Herzmuskulatur. Cardio- logia, Basel, 1937, 1: 234-50. ---- Purkinje fibers. Bellermann, W. *Histologische Unter- suchungen uber die Striiktur und das Glykogen des Reizleitungssystems, speziell der Purkinje- schen Fasern [Kiel] 21p. 8? Quakenbruck, 1935. ^ Abramson, D. I., & Margolin, S. A purkinje conduction network in the myocardium of the mammalian ventricles. J. Anat., Lond., 1935-36, 70: 250-9, 6 pl.—Glomset, D. J., & Glomset, A. T. A. A morphologic study of the cardiac con- duction system in ungulates, dog, and man; the Purkinje system. Am. Heart J., 1940, 20: 677-701.—Kolmer, W., & t leischmann, W. Ueber den Sauerstoffverbrauch der Purkinje- schen Faden Arch. ges. Physiol., 1927, 218: 530—Lapicque, M., & Veil, C. Chronaxie des fibres de Purkinje dans le cceur. C rend Soc. biol., 1924, 91: 368-70.—Robb, J.' S. Concerning the distribution of the Purkinje substance and certain physio- logical implications dependent thereon. Am. J. Physiol., 1936, 116: 129.—Romieu, M., & Linas, G. Caracteres morphologi- ques du teseau de Purkinje du coeur de I'homme. C. rend. Acad, sc, 1937, 205: 1259-61.—Schmidt, W. J. Ueber die Doppelbrechung des Zytoplasmas der Purkinjeschen Faden im Herzen des Schafes. Zschr. Zellforsch., 1937, 26: 728-32.— Soejima, T. Ueber das Ueberleben der Purkinje'schen Fasern des Rinderherzens. Fukuoka acta med., 1928 21: 104.— Strasser, U. Studien an der uberlebenden Purkinje-Faser dea Katzenherzens. Arch. exp. Path., Lpz., 1928, 136: 101-12.— iakai, T. Ueber die Wirkung von einigen Reizen auf die blossgelegten Purkinje-Fasern des Rinderherzens. Jap. J. M. be 1938, 5: Proc. Biophysics, 123.—Vitali, G. Contributo alio studio del sistema muscolare specifico del cuore; le expansioni fif^nno'6 fiA*?re (l',PurkinJe in Ovis aries. Anat. Anz., 1937, 84: 88-102 Also Monit. zool. ital., 1937, 47: SuddI.. 89-91. Also Verh. Anat. Ges.. 1937, 44: 49. HEART CONDUCTION 259 HEART CONDUCTION ---- Recovery phase. Ashman, R., & Herrmann, G. R. A supernormal phase in conduction and a recovery curve for the human junctional tissues. Am. Heart J., 1925-26, 1: 594-616—Gayda, T. Sulla fase supernormale del istabilimento del cuore dopo la sistole. Arch. sc. biol., Nap., 1926, 9: 1-40.—Hoff, H. E., & Nahum, L. H. The supernormal period in the mammalian ventricle. Am. J. Physiol., 1938, 124: 591-5.—Jervell, A. Nachweis einer supernormalen Reizbarkeitsphase in einem Falle von partiellem Block. Acta med. scand., 1934, Suppl., 59, 626- 33.—Okiyama, M. Ueber die Erholung der atrioventrikularen Reizleitung, besonders die refraktare Periode des Reizleitungs- systems; untersucht am intakten Krotenherzen. Jap. J. M. Sc, 1933-35, 3: Proc. Biophysics, 199-201. ------Shinko, T., & Nomura, I. Ueber die relativen Erholungskurven des Reizleitungssvstems des Frosch- und Krotenherzens. Ibid., 1936-38, 4: Proc Biophysics, 85-7.—Scherf, D., & Schott, A. The supernormal phase of recovery in man. Am.' Heart J., 1939, 17: 357-67.—Segers, M. L'influence de la phase super- normale d'excitabilite sur le rythme spontane ou provoque des oreillettes droite et gauche du lapin; extrasystolie et tachy- cardie paroxystique. C. rend. Soc. biol., 1939, 130: 1359-63.— Ulke, G., & Vedoya, R. Fase supernormal de recuperacion; consideraciones sugeridas por el estudio de un caso. Rev. argent, card., 1941-42, 8: 70.—Wolferth, C. C. The so-called supernormal recovery phase of conduction in heart muscle. Am. Heart J., 1927-28, 3: 706-11. ---- sino-auricular. Condorelli, L. Ueber die Bahnen der Reizleitung vom Keith- Flackschen Knoten zu den Vorhofen. Zschr. ges. exp. Med., 1929, 68: 493-515. ------ Dieci anni di ricerche sul mec- canismo di conduzione dello stimolo nei miocardio atriale. Fol. med., Nap., 1936, 22: 99-117.—Drury, A.N.,&Regnier, M. Observations upon conduction in the mammalian heart, auric- ular conduction. Heart, Lond., 1927-28, 14: 263-81, pl — Geraudel, E. Le vestibule sinusal; ses connexions avec l'oreillette et le ventricule; les voies vestibulaires. Ann. med., Par., 1929, 26: 269-97, 3 pl.—Nomura, S., & Ida, H. Histo- logische Untersuchungen fiber die Verbindung zwischen Sinus- knoten und Tawara'schem Knoten, und iiber den Sinusknoten. Taiwan igakkai zasshi, 1928, 68.—Preyer, J. _ Die Ueber- tragung der Ursprungsantriebe von Sinus nach den Vorhofen beim Herzen von Testudo graeca L. Zschr. vergl. Physiol., 1931, 15: 556-67.—Rijlant, P. Contributions k l'etude de l'automatisme et de la conduction dans le cceur; conduction intra-auriculaire chez le mammifere. Arch, internat. physiol., Liege, 1926, 27: 225-53.------- Conduction intra-auriculaire chez le mammifere. C. rend. Soc. biol., 1926, 94: 1028-31. ----- Contribution k l'etude de l'endocarde auriculaire (tissu de conduction) chez le mammifere. Ibid., 1927, 96: 1050-3. ------ La conduction dans l'oreillette droite du cceur du mammifere. Ibid., 1930, 103: 909-13.—Rothberger, C. J., & Scherf, D. Ueber die Erregungsfortpflanzung vom Sinusknoten auf den Vorhof. Wien. klin. Wschr., 1926, 39: 470. Also Zschr. ges. exp. Med., 1926-27, 53: 792-835 — Roversi, A. S. I nuovi reperti anatomici sul tessuto specifico di conduzione negU atri. Cuore & circol., 1929, 13: 285-97.— Segre, R. Recherches sur la portion sino-auriculaire du systeme de conduction du cceur humain. Arch. mal. cceur, 1926, 19: 295-302. ---- Sino-auricular node [Keith-Flack] Arpino, G. Die Innervation des Sinusknotens bei Delphinus delphis L. Anat. Anz., 1933-34, 77: 241-52.—Borisova, E. I., & Rusinov, V. S. On the twofold influence of excitation of the heart pace-maker. Acta med. URSS, 1940, 3: 170-84 — Borman, M. C. Experiments on the sino-auricular node. West Virginia M. J., 1927, 23: 505-9.—Bruni, A. C, & Segre, R. Sdoppiamento del nodo del seno nei cuore umano. Atti Soc. lombard. sc. med., 1924, 13: 462-4.—Chiodi, V. Intorno al nodo seno-atriale in alcuni mammiferi. Monit. zool. ital., 1930-31, 41: Suppl., 174-8. Also Clin, vet., Milano, 1932, 55: 689; 799.—Condorelli, L. Ricerche sperimentali suUa conduzione sino-nodale. Cuore & circol., 1930, 14: 221-39, 4 pl.—Eccles. J. C, & Hoff, H. E. The rhythm of the heart beat; location, action potential, and electrical excitability of the pacemaker. Proc. R. Soc, Lond., 1934, ser. B, 115: 307-27, pl—Fredericq, L. La suppression du noeud de Keith-Flack. Bull. Acad. med. Belgique, 1926, 5. ser., 6: 461-71, 6 pl.—Glomset, D. J.. At Glomset, A. T. A. A morphologic study of the cardiac conduc- tion system in ungulates, dog, and man; the sinoatrial node. Am. Heart J., 1940, 20: 389-98,—Gurewitsch, E. S. Die Abhangigkeit der traumatischen Extrasystolie des isolierten Herzens vom Zustand des Keith-Flackschen Knotens. Zschr Kreislaufforsch., 1932, 24: 571.—Heinbecker, P. The potential analysis of a pacemaker mechanism in Limulus polyphemus. Am. J. Physiol., 1936, 117: 686-700.—La Franca, S. Le glycogene de I'appareil specifique du cceur dans ses rapports avec la fonction cardiaque; le noeud de Keith et Flack. Arch. internat. physiol., Liege, 1921-22, 17: 266770.—Martini, I. Contributo alia conoscenza del nodo senoatriale del cuore dei mammiferi; il nodo del seno del daino. Profilassi, 1933, 6: 225-8.—Meek, W. J., Keenan, M., & Theisen, H. J. Ihe auricular blood supply in the dog; general auricular supply, with special reference to the sino-auricular node. Am. Heart J., 1928-29, 4: 591-9.—Mitolo, M. II puntoprimariodieccitazione ritmica, pace-maker, del cuore di Bufo vulgaris. Boll, hoc ital. biol. sper., 1938, 13: 694.—Pace, D. Ricerche sul nodo sinusale della talpa. Monit. zool. ital., 1932, 42: Suppl., 49-53.—Paff, G. H. Conclusive evidence for sino-atrial dominance in isolated 48-hour embryonic chick hearts cultivated in vitro. Anat Rec, 1935-36, 63: 203-10.—Pugliese, R. II nodo seno-atriale nei cuore dello scimpanze. Cuore & circol., 1934, 18: 303-15.— Ravotti, G. R. Contributo alia conoscenza dell'apparato di conduzione del cuore; osservazioni sul nodo seno-atriale del Cebus capucinus. Ibid., 1936, 20: 132-9.—Roversi, A. S. Contributi sperimentali alia fisiologia del nodo cavo-atriale, in rapporto a nuovi reperti anatomici. Arch, fisiol., Fir., 1929, 27: 190-214. Also Arch. ital. biol., 1930-31, 82: 26-39, 5 pl. Contribution clinique a l'etude du nceud cavo-auricu- laire. Arch. mal. coeur, 1930, 23: 369-86.—Segre, R. Ulteriori ricerche sul nodo del seno. Atti Soc. lombard. sc. med., 1927, 16: 238-45.—Spealman, C. R. A right-atrium preparation for studying pace-maker activity and amplitude of contraction. Proc Soc. Exp. Biol., N. Y., 1940, 45: 189.—Stienon, L. Recherches sur l'origine du nceud sinusal dans le cceur des mammiferes. Arch, biol., Liege, 1926, 36: 523-39.—Yater, W. M. Cross striations of the muscle fibers of the sino-auricular node. J. Am. M. Ass., 1930, 94: 1232. ---- Sinus venosus. Tigerstedt, R., & Stromberg, C. A. Der Venensinus des Froschherzens, physiologisch untersucht. 67p. 22}/2cm. Stockh., 1888. Armstrong, C. W. J., & Fisher, K. C. The effect of oxygen tension on cyanide inhibition of the frequency of the isolated frog sinus. Am. J. Physiol., 1941, 133: 198.—Brown, D. E. S. Temperature and the responsive mechanism of cardiac muscle; temperature and the rate of the rhythm of the isolated sinus. J. Exp. Biol., Lond., 1930, 7: 385-9.—Estable, C, & Vaz Ferreira, A. Examen microscopique in vivo et in situ du sinus cardiaque. C. rend. Soc. biol., 1931, 108: 905.—Garrey, W. E., & King, C. E. Localization of the pacemaker; impulse trans- mission in the sinus venosus of the turtle heart. Am. J. Physiol., 1941, 133: 288.—Geraudel, E. Le vestibule sinusal; ses connexions avec l'oreillette et le ventricule; le signe de la contraction auriculaire satellite. Ann. med., Par., 1929, 26: 351-76, 2 ch. ------ Le vestibule sinusal de l'oreillette, son role en physiologie cardiaque. Bull. Acad, med., Par., 1929, 3. ser., 102: 319-23.—Gramenitsky, M. I. [New heterotopic automatic center in the frog's heart; functional and anatomical significance of the aperture of the venous sinus (Ostium sinus venosi)] Tr. Vtor. Leningr. med. inst., 1935, No. 6, 66-73. Also Arch. ges. Physiol., 1934-35, 235: 764-70.— Honger, R. Untersuchungen iiber die elektrische Ladung des Sinus des Froschherzens unter dem Einflusse autonomer Nervenreizung und autonomer Nervenendgifte. Arch. exp. Path., Berl., 1935- 36, 180: 266-74.—Kisch, B. Nachweis, dass Kaliumsalzzufuhr potentielle Reizbildungsstellen des Venensinus in aktuelle verwandeln kann. Arch. ges. Physiol., 1926-27, 215: 673.— Morin, G., & Jullien, A. Sur l'automatisme des sinus contrac- tiles de l'embryon de la limace agreste dans des solutions de concentration et de composition salines variees. C. rend. Soc. biol., 1931, 106: 1038-40.—Quiring, D. P. The development of the sino-atrial region of the chick heart. J. Morph. Physiol., 1933, 55: 81-118.—Rawlinson, H. E. The later development of the sinus venosus and the relation of the sino-atrial node to it, in the calf heart. Anat. Rec, 1931, 49: 89-95.— Rienmiiller, J. Ueber die Wirkung des konstanten Stromes auf den Sinus des Warmbluterherzens. Arch. ges. Physiol., 1935, 236: 568- 74.—Wirz, P. Elektrostatische Messungen am Sinus des Froschherzens und an der Blase, unter verschiedenen experi- mentellen Bedingungen. Ausz. Inaugur. Diss. Med. Fak. Univ. Bern (1931-33) 1934, No. 77, 1-3. ---- ventricular. Abramson, D. I., & Jochim, K. The spread of the impulse in the mammalian ventricle. Am. J. Physiol., 1937, 120: 635-48.—Bergami, G. La conduzione dell'eccitamento del miocardio ventricolare. Arch. sc. biol., Nap., 1928, 12: 586- 94.—Hukuhara, T., & Komita, S. Pflanzt sich die Reizung der Kammer bei Saugetieren auf die Vorhofe fort? Arch. ges. Physiol., 1938-39, 241: 444-8.—Kerber, B. Analyse des Erregungsablaufes innerhalb der Herzkammer. Verh. Deut. Ges. Kreislaufforsch., 1934, 7: 269-73 [Discussion] 279-83.— Lutembacher, R. Propagation de l'onde de contraction dans le ventricule de la grenouille. Arch. mal. coeur, 1937, 30: 191; 1938, 31: 25.—Pannier, R. L'invasion du ventricule de la tortue par l'onde d'excitation. C. rend. Soc. biol., 1940, 133: 98-100 —Robb, J. S. The role of muscle bundles in ventricular conduction. M. & S. Yearb. Physicians Hosp. Plattsburgh, 1929, 1: 210-6, 6 pl. ---- in animals. Aagaard, O. C, & Hall, H. C. Ueber Injektionen des Reizleitungssystems und der Lymphgefasse des Saugetier- herzens. Anat. Hefte, 1914, 51: 357-425, 8 pl.—Agduhr, E. Morphologische Uebersicht uber das myogene Reizleitungs- system des Herzens bei den Vertebraten Upsala lak. foren. forh 1927 n. F., 33: 271-99.—Boer, S. de. Vergleichende Physiologie des Herzens von Evertebraten; Erregungsleitung des Herzens bei Lamellibranchiaten Zschr. vergl. Physiol., 1929, 9: 67-73.—Cardwell, J. C, & Abramson, D. I. The atrioventricular conduction system of the beef heart. Am. J. HEART CONDUCTION 260 HEART DILATATION Anat., 1931, 49: 167-92.—Cattaneo, L. Osservazioni sull'ap- parato di conduzione del cuore di nccelli. Monit. zool. ital., 1937, 47: Suppl., 25N-60.-—Davies, F. The conducting system of the bird's heart. J. Anat., Lond., 1929-30, 64: 129; 4 pl.; 319, 3 pl. ------ The conducting system of the monotreme heart. Ibid., 1930-31, 65: 339-51. 4 pl.—Eoyersi, A. S. Sul tessuto miocardico specifico dell'apparato di conduzione del cuore dei mammiferi. Monit. zool. ital., 1937, 47: Suppl., 201.—Goldenberg, M., & Rothberger, C. J. Untersuchungen an der spezifischen Muskulatur des Hundeherzens. Arch. ges. Physiol., 1935, 236: 277-97.—Jullien, A., & Vairel-Blanc. Sur les voies de progression de l'onde de contraction cardiaque chez l'escargot. Ann. physiol., Par., 1936, 12: 751-3.— Keith, A., & Flack, M. The form and nature of the muscular connections between the primary divisions of the vertebrate heart. In Cardiac Classics (Willius, F. A.) S. Louis, 1941, 747-62.—Mettam, R. W. The ati io-ventricular system of the equine heart. Rep. Dir. Vet. Educ. Pretoria, 1928. 13:-14: pt 2, 745-52, 4 pl.—Ohmori, S. Vergleichend-anatomische und entwicklungsgeschichtliche Untersuchungen iiber das Atrioventrikularverbindungssystem des Kaltbliiterherzens. Fukuoka acta med., 1927, 20: 88.—Redaelli, P. Osservazioni istopatologiche sugli elementi del fascio di conduzione nei cuore di cavallo. Boll. Soc. med. chir., Pavia, 1929, n. ser., 4: 129-40.—Rijlant, P. La conduction dans le cceur du mammi- fere. Ann. physiol., Par., 1931, 7: 229. ------ Le phenomene de la conduction dans le cceur de la limule polypheme. C. rend. Soc. biol., 1931, 108: 830-2.—Ter Borg, H. Das Reizleitungs- system in Atrium und Ventrikel insbesondere beim Pferde. Verh. Deut. Ges. Kreislaufforsch., 1939, 12: 174-7.—Tondo, M. Sulla fine irrorazione sanguifera del sistema di conduzione atrio-ventricolare di alcuni manimiferi. Boll. Soc ital. biol. sper., 1938, 13: 150-2.—Yokochi, K. Vergleichend-anatomische Studie iiber das Nervensvstem und das Reizleitungssystem des Herzens. Tr. Jap. Path. Soc, 1925, 15: 84. Also Jap. J. M. Sc, 1926-31, 1: Tr. Path., 147-73, pl. HEART dilatation [and enlargement] See also' Heart failure; Heart hypertrophy; Heart muscle, Tonus; Heart valve, Disease. Brams, W. A., & Katz, L. N. Studies on the overdistended heart; effects of venesection. Am. J. Physiol., 1931, 98: 556-68.—Galata, G. Effetti cardiaci e circolatori della contro- pressione externa sul cuore dilatato. Fisiol. & med., Roma, 1932, 3: 149-69.—Ivanov, A. N. Ouelques reflexions sur la dilatation du cceur. Rev. med., Par., 1929, 46: 255-63 — Katz, L. N., & Brams, W. A. Studies on the overdistended heart; the role of relaxation in filling the distended and over- distended heart. Am. J. Physiol., 1931, 98: 569-71.—Kessler, G. L. Enormous cardiac distension. J. Am. M. Ass., 1926, 86: 32.—Kirk, H. Cardiac dilatation. Act. Rec, Lond., 1938, 50: 122.—Mansfeld, G. Das Problem der Herzerweiterung. Arch. exp. Path., Lpz., 1928, 138: 129. ------ & Hecht, K. Die mechanischen und energetischen Folgen der Herzerweiter- ung. Arch. ges. Physiol., 1933, 232: 657-65.—Marmorstein. M. I. [Sur la dilatation experimentale du coeur chez le chien] Med. exp., Kharkov, 1937, No. 5, 67-78.—Morin. P. Pro- nostic des dilatations cardiaques par l'orthodiagraphie en serie. Union med. Canada, 1932, 61: 1036-8.—Moritz, F. Herz- dilatation. Munch, med. Wschr., 1935, 82: 450-2. ---- acute. See also Heart muscle, Fatigue. Badertscher, V. A. Acute cardiac compression resulting from the restraining influence of the pericardium during acute dilatation of the heart; observation of 3 cases during peri- cardial exploration. Am. J. Surg., 1940, 50: 367-70.—Boisseau, J., & Bourner, P. Disparition momentanee du signe de Babinski et de la contracture chez une hemiplegique, au cours de crises de dilatation aigue du cceur. Rev. neur., Par., 1934, 41: 114.—Buchbinder, W. C. Absence of axis deviation of electro- cardiogram in acute heart dilatation following experimental embolism with metallic mercury. Proc Soc. Exp. Biol N. Y., 1929-30, 27: 540-2. ------& Katz, L. N. The electro- cardiogram in acute experimental distention of the right heart Am. J. M. So., 1934, 187: 785-92, 4 pl.—Clark, J. H. Acute cardiac dUatation; an ever present danger in intravenous in- jections. J. Am. M. Ass., 1927, 89: 21.—Gavioli, R. L. Dila- taci6r aguda de corazon en el parte. Sem. med., B. Air., 1934,' 41: 99-104.—Henschen, C. Vortauschung eines Hamoperi- kards durch eine akute traumatische Herzdilatation. Schweiz med. Wschr., 1934, 64: 626-9.—Klaus, E. J. Untersuchungen iiber die RuckbUdung der Ueberanstrengungs-dilatation des Herzens bei einem jugendlichen Wettkampfsportler Zschr Kreislaufforsch., 1939, 31: 7-16.—Kucera, L., & Mentl, s! [Differential diagnosis in acute dilatation of the heart and exudative pericarditis] Cas. lek. cesk., 1931, 70: 1771-5__ Loewy, A., & Mayer, A. E. Leber experimented erzeugte akute Herzerweiterungen bi-im Menschen. Klin. Wschr 1926, 5: 1213-6.—Meyer, A. Dn akute Herzdilatation. Ibid' 1934, 13: 758-60.—Pardellas, R. Insufficiencia circulatoria por dilatacao aguda do coracao direito, na gravida Rev gyn. obst., Rio, 1929, 23: 468-72.—Renner, A. E.' Acute cardiac dilatation. Med. Rev. of Rev., 1924 30- 178 — Van Liere, E. J., & Allen, R. S. The significance of the peri- cardium in acute cardiac dilatation produced by anoxemia Am. J. Physiol., 1927, 83: 225-30. Also repr.—Waldman A [Acute fatal dilatation of the heart] Klin, med., Moskva, 1928, 6: 44-8.—Workmen's compensation act; acute dilatation of heart due to strain. J. Am. M. Ass., 1940, 114: 436.—Zorrilla y Polanco, A. Un curioso caso de dilatacion aguda, refleja, de coraz6n. Arch, med., Madr., 1927, 26: 295-7. ---- Diagnosis. See also Heart, Measurement; Heart, Radi- ography, &c. Bordet, E. La dilatation du coeur; etude radioscopiquc. 152p. 8? Par., 1926. Esser, (J. *Ueber das kymographische Ver- halten der Herzspitze bei ausgesprochener Dila- tation. p.213-22. 4? Miinch., 1935. Also Fortsch. Rontgenstrahl., 1935, 52: Dumas, A., Sedallian [et al.] Eclatement du coeur droit par precipitation chez un asystolique k gros coeur. Lyon med., 1936, 157: 598-601.—Fray, W. W. Mensuration of the heart and chest in the left posterioanterior oblique position a comparative studv; determination of type of cardiac enlarge- ment (right or left) Am. J. Roentg., 1932, 27: 363-72.— Giraud, G. La dilatation du cceur; etude radioscopique. Montpellier med., 1926, 48: 217-28.—Heckmann, K. Die paradoxe Atembewegung des dilatierten Herzens. Wien. klin. Wschr., 1940, 53: 587.—Jarisch, A., & Loos, H. O. Ueber die Formveranderungen des Herzens bei experimentellen Herzer- weiterungen. Ibid., 1931, 44: 844.—Martini, T., & Gourdy, C. A. Las seudodilataciones del coraz6n derecho. Sem. mfd., B. Air., 1927, 34: pt 2, 876-9.—Merighi, F. Intorno alia vera natura del fenomeno di Giacomo Minerbi. Minerva med., Tor., 1926, 6: 421-4.—Paschetta, V. Le signe oesophagien des dilatations cardiaques. Arch, electr. med., 1931, 39: 1-7.— Podkaminsky, N. A. Le diagnostic radiologique de l'hyper- trophie de la dilatation partielle du coeur. Bull. Soc. radiol. med. France, 1932, 20: 291. ---- Etiology and pathogenesis. See also Heart failure; Heart muscle, Disease; Heart valves, Disease, &c. Blake, J. E. Cardiac dilatation following acute infectious diseases. N. York State J. M., 1907, 7: 438-46.—Bordet, E. Sur certains cas de dilatation du cceur apres l'operation de Brauer. Prat. med. fr., 1928, 7: 18-22.—Brooks, H. Dilata- tion of the heart in the acute fevers. N. York M. J., 1911, 94: 509-12.—Galata, G. Di un fenomeno espansorio del cuore qual'effetto di stimolazioni meccaniche. Arch, fisiol., Fir., 1926, 24: 308-21.—Kirch, E. Untersuchungen iiber tonogene Herzdilatation. Verh. Deut. path. Ges., 1926, 21: 391-8. Also Zbl. allg. Path., 1926, 37: 552. ------ Der Entwicklungs- ablauf der rechtsseitigen tonogenen Herzdilatation bei Mensch und Versuchstier und seine physiologische Erklarung. Vir- chows Arch., 1933, 291: 682-94.—Manicatide, M., & Rosen- krantz, B. Sur la pathogenie du claquement valvulaire et de I'elargissement de l'ombre des vaisseaux de la base du cceur. C. rend. Soc. biol., 1928, 99: 1359.—Mansfeld, G., & Hecht, K. Lnlersuchungen iiber Herzmuskeltonus und die experimentelle Dilatation des Warmbluterherzens. Arch. ges. Physiol, 1933, 232: 643-56.—Marmorstein, M. Contribution k l'etude des dilatations experimentales du coeur chez le chien. Rev. med., Par., 1936, 53: 263-71, 3 pl., 2 graph.—Monks, L. Experimentelle Studie uber tonogene Herzdilatation durch Zuflussvermehrung. Zschr. Kreislaufforsch., 1939, 31: 191- 205.—Nicotra, A. Un caso di enorme dilatazione cardiaca premortale. Arch, radiol., Nap., 1931, 7: 473-9.—Schneider, G. Ueber die medikamentose Beeinflussung der experimen- tellen rechtsseitigen tonogenen Herzdilatation. Arch. exp. Path., Lpz., 1937, 187: 344-9.—Vannotti, A., & Blunschy, A. Die Capillardurchblutung des Myokardes bei der experi- mentellen akuten und subakuten tonogenen Herzdilatation. Zschr. ges. exp. Med., 1939, 105: 447-62.—Wilson, C. Physi- ological dilatation of the heart; a study in clinical physiology. Brit M. J., 1930, 1: 189-91.—Zdansky, E. Herzerweiterung bei Myokardlasion im Rontgenbilde. Wien. klin. Wschr., 1935, 48: 1069. HEART disease. See also Cardiovascular system, Disease; Heart, Abnormity; Heart arrhythmia; Heart auricle, Disease, &c.; Heart failure; Heart muscle; Heart rheumatism, &c; Mediastinum, Disease; Pulmonary artery, Disease, &c. Ceconi, A. Malattie organiche del cuore. p.170-260. 8? Tor., 1931. In Med. int. (Ceconi) Tor., 1931, 2: Smith, F. M. Diseases of the heart, p.393- 494. 8? Phila., 1938. In Int. Med. (Musser, J. H.) 3. ed., Phila., 1938. ao Bi*r,rinS» w- L. Heart disease. J. Lancet, 1935, 55: 129- oo'i cAUm|art' H- L" Heart disease- N- England J. M., 1939, £Zi: 609-16. —---- Cardiology; chemotherapy in heart dis- ease; the false diagnosis of organic heart disease. Ibid., 1941, HEART DISEASE 261 HEART DISEASE 225: 782-8.—Brock, L. W. Heart disease; incidence, cause and treatment of some of the common types. N. Orleans M. & S. J., 1933, 86: 355.—Cabot, R. C. Heart trouble. N. England J. M., 1935, 212: 685-8.—Gartrell, E. Heart disease. Austra- las. Nurs. J., 1937, 35: 49-52.—Churchill, J. F. Cardiac irregu- larities; their significance and treatment. Rocky Mountain M. J., 1941, 38: 971-7.—Falk, O. P. J. The present day status of heart disease. J. Missouri M. Ass., 1933, 30: 280-8.— Fenwick, D. E. Some aspects of heart disease. N. Zealand M. J., 1925-26, 24: 273-81.—Garneau, G. Considerations pratiques sur le cceur de nos malades en general. Union med. Canada, 1941, 70: 1354.—Hanger, F. M. Disease of the heart. Bol. As. med. Puerto Rico, 1933, 25: 63-72.—Heart disease. Ind. M. Rec, 1936, 56: 244-7.—Holbrook, J. S. Heart con- ditions. South. M. & S., 1934, 96: 222^.—Hurxthal, L. M. Heart disease. N. England J. M., 1934, 211: 61-3.—Jirka, F. J. Heart disease. Illinois M. J., 1935, 67: 279-84.—Kinsella, R. A. The career of the heart. Hosp. Progr., 1936, 17: 429- 31. Also Illinois M. J., 1936, 70: 55-7.—Lyon, R. A'. Heart disease. In Cyclop. Med. (Piersol-Bortz) Phila., 1940, serv. vol., 559; 572.—McPhedran, A. Cardiac disease. Canad. M. Ass. J., 1926, 16: 627-9.—Meakins, J. C. Cardiac lesions. Proc. Interst. Postgrad. M. Ass. N. America, 1925, 1: 388-94.— Moon, R. O. Some minor cardiac affections. Practitioner, Lond., 1934, 132: 587-95.—Nied, W. Herzkrankheiten. Med. Klin., Berl., 1938, 34: 1624; 1658.—Nuckols, O. P. The cardiopath. Kentucky M. J., 1934, 32: 246-50.—Pope, C. Cardiac diseases. Clin. Med., 1926, 33: 246-8.—Russell, R. O. Heart disease. J. M. Ass. Alabama, 1934-35, 4: 390-2.— Shuman, J. W. Heart disease. Med. J. & Rec, 1926, 124: 763.—Sullivan, A. G. Diseases of the heart. J. Arkansas M. Soc, 1934, 31: 14—Verdu Ripoll, E. Estudio hist6rico de las cardiopatfas des Hipocrates. Tr. Cdted. hist. crit. med., Madr., 1934, 2: 351-66.—Weicksel, J. Krankheiten des Herzens. Med. Novit., Lpz., 1934, 43: 33-5.—Yater, W. M. Diseases of the heart. Med. Ann. District Columbia, 1933, 2: 259; 91; 1934, 3: 13; passim. ---- Age of patient. See also Heart disease, juvenile. Bibb, J. L. Heart disease in middle life. Internat. J. M. & S., 1930, 43: 565-9.—Boas, E. P. Heart diseases of middle life. Hygeia, Chic, 1935, 13: 312-4.—Cardiac disease in middle life. Med. Off., Lond., 1937, 58: 56.—Dexter, S. O., jr, & Farns- worth, D. L. Nonvalvular heart disease under the age of 46 years. Ann. Int. M., 1936-37, 10: 1514-30.—East, T. The prevention and treatment of heart disease in middle age. Brit. J. Phys. M., 1934-35, 9: 234.—Falk, O. P. J. Treatment of the cardiac episodes of middle life. J. Missouri M. Ass., 1933, 30: 443-8. Also repr.—Galli, G. Giovinezza e vecchiaia dal punto di vista cardiologico. Gazz. osp., 1935, 56: 94-8.—Gelman, I., & Pusik, W. Zur pathohistologischen und elektrokardio- graphischen Charakteristik des Herzens in hohem Alter. Zschr. Kreislaufforsch., 1936, 28: 570-7.—Goldsmith, M. A. Heart disease in the adult. Pub. Health Nurs., 1941, 33: 226- 9.—MacKenzie, A. J. Cardiac disease in middle life. S. Michael Hosp. M. Bull., Toronto, 1929-30 4: 50-4. Also Canad. M. Ass. J., 1930, 23: 370-4.— Malattie (Le) della vecchiaja; effetti e complicanze di cardiopatie; igiene e cura. Progr. ter., Milano, 1903, 152-9.—Oille, J. A. Heart disease in adult life. Canad. Pub. Health J., 1932, 23: 403.—Riche, H. G. Heart disease in middle life. N. Orleans M. & S. J., 1935-36, 88: 610-4.—Riesman, D. The nonvalvular diseases of the heart in middle life. Bull. N. York Acad. M., 1930, 2. ser., 6: 536-52. Also South. M. & S., 1930, 92: 479-86.—Robey, W. H. Heart disease in middle age. N. England J. M., 1934, 210: 438-40.—Sundell, C. E. Treatment of the heart in middle age. Med. Press & Circ, Lond., 1934, 188: 505-8.—Traitement (Le) de la senilite cardiaque. Progr. med., Par., 1938, 1041.— Willius, F. A. Cardiac clinics; a talk on the adjustment of man to the advancing years of life. Proc. Mayo Clin., 1939, 14: 41-3. ---- arteriosclerotic. See also Aorta, Arteriosclerosis; Arteriosclero- sis; Coronary arteries, sclerosis. Berghoff, R. S. Arterio-sclerotic heart disease. Illinois M. J., 1941, 80: 320-2.—Birchard, C. C. The arterio-sclerotic heart. Abstr. Proc. Ass. Life Insur. M. Dir. America, 1931, 18: 217-38.—Bias Moia. Recientes adquisiciones en el estudio de la patologia coronaria y del corazon arterioescleroso. Dia med., B. Air., 1938, 10: 245-8.—Butler, G. R. Arterio-sclerosis and the heart. Tr. M. Soc. N. York, 1903, 92-5.—Campbell, D. G. Arteriosclerosis and angina pectoris with temporary muscular paralysis. Canad. M. Ass. J., 1922, 12: 107.—Delcourt, A. J. Contribution to the clinical study of the arterio-sclerosis of the heart. N. Orleans M. & S. J., 1912-13, 65: 275-87.—Herz, M. Vortragszyklus iiber Herzkrankheiten; Arteriosklerose. Wien. med. Wschr., 1910, 60: 2869-77.—Hohn, J. Beitrage zur Arteriosklerose des Herzens und ihrer Behandlung. Oesterr. Aerzte Ztg, 1911, 8: 201; 220.—Katz, L. N., Sanders, A. [et al.] Heart size and experimental atheromatosis in the rabbit. Am. J. M. Sc, 1940, 200: 731-9, pl.—Klemperer [On the prognosis in cardiac arteriosclerosis] Prakt. vrach, 1915, 14: 173-5.— Lisa, J. R., & Brown, C. R. Arteriolar disease of the heart. Ann. Int. M., 1940-41, 14: 2147-56.—Schneider, A. Beobach- tungen iiber den Krankheitsanfang bei arteriosklerotischen Herzleiden. Med. Welt, 1935, 9: 1664.—Stroud, W. D. The miQcaolm2nLof arteriosclerotic heart disease. Yale J. Biol., ----■ Associated diseases. Austrian, C. R. Heart disease and its relation to tubercu- losis. Mod. Concepts Card. Dis., 1933, 2: 1.—Barker, L. F tuberculosis; heart disease; postencephalitic Parkinsonism. Froc Interst. Postgrad. M. Ass. N. America, 1932, 100-6.— Laussade, G., & Amsler, R. Quelques particularites cliniques de la tuberculose pulmonaire au cours des cardiopathies. Bull Soc med. h6p. Paris, 1934, 3. ser., 50: 1018-22.—Clark, W. I. fleets of accidents on cardiac employees. Am. Heart J., 1927-28, 3:539-45.—Hendrickx. Tuberculose et cardiopathies. Arch. med. beiges, 1935, 88: 192-7.—Knopf, S. A. Heart disease and tuberculosis; diaphragmatic respiration and other efforts to lessen their prevalence. Med. Rec, N. Y., 1935, 141: 5-11-—Moon, R. O. A case of heart disease and epilepsy; with a note on their association. Lancet, Lond., 1926, 2: 65.— Pissavy & Maximin, M. Les pleutesies tuberculeuses chez les cardiaques. Sem. hop. Paris, 1926, 3: 48.—Smith, G. Various pathological conditions which effect the progress of cardiac cases. Pub. Health J., Toronto, 1925-26, 16: 563-7. ---- Autonomic nervous system. See also Heart nerves; Heart neurosis. Averbuck, S. H., & Rachmilewitz, M. Untersuchungen uber die Bedeutung des Ganglion stellatum fur das geschadigte Herz. Zschr. ges. exp. Med., 1931, 75: 552-61.—Kabanov, N. [Vegetative system in cardiac diseases] Vrach. delo, 1935, 18: 617-26.—Kogan-Jasny, V. Herz und vegetatives System. In Bain. & Balneother. (Karlsbad, arztl. Vortr., 1933) 1935, 14: 491-520.—Maliner, M. M. The vegetative nervous system in children with heart disease. Arch. Pediat., N. Y., 1933, 50: I3O75.—Spagnoletti, G. Calcemia e potassiemia nei cardio- patici sotto lo stimolo del sistema neuro-vegetative Gior. med. mil., 1938, 86: 1063-79. ---- Blood, and hematopoietic system. Forstmann, J. W. *Ueber die Blutsenkungs- geschwindigkeit der Erythrocyten bei Herz- krankheiten. 41p. 8? Berl., 1930. Antonelli, G. La velocity di sedimentazione dei globuli rossi in alcuni stati morbosi, con speciale riguardo alle cardiopatie. Cuore & circol., 1926, 10: 99-121—D'Alessandria, E. La resistenza globulare nei cardiopatici. Gazz. internaz. med. chir., 1930, 38: 496-503.—Fanelli, Z. F. La formula leucoci- taria e lo schema neutrofilo di Arneth nelle cardiopatie. Rinasc. med., 1931, 8: 375.—Garamvolgyi, K., & Garamvolgyi, D. [Changes in halometric diameter of erythrocytes in compensated and decompensated heart diseases] Orv. hetil., 1937, 81: 701- 3.—Marchal, G. Les troubles cardiaques d'origine anemique. Concours med., 1940, 62: 777.—Masel, I., & Einhorn, E. Untersuchungen iiber den Durchmesser und das Volum der Erythrozyten verschiedener Gefassgebiete bei Herzkranken. Deut. Arch. klin. Med., 1930, 167: 288-93.—Strasser, A. Ueber Spatfolgen der Kreislaufstorungen; die Polyglobulie der Herzkranken und ihre Behandlung. Zschr. ges. phys. Ther., 1923, 27: 71-80.—Wood, P. The erythrocyte sedimentation rate in diseases of the heart. Q. J. Med., Lond., 1936, 5:1-19.— Zobak, I. [Differential-diagnostic significance of erythrocyte sedimentation in endocarditis lenta and other cardiac diseases] Vrach. gaz., 1928, 32: 648-55. ---- Blood circulation, and blood vessels. Borruso, G. Ricerche sulla velocity di corrente del sangue nelle cardiopatie. Cuore & circol., 1933, 17: 675-700.— Bourne, G. The cardiac circulation and disease. Lancet, Lond., 1926, 2: 491-3.—Ceccaredi, D. Ricerche sulla velocity di corrente del sangue nelle cardiopatie. Riv. osp., 1933, 23: 257-82.—Crawford, J. H. Studies on human capillaries; observations in cases of heart disease with regular rhythm. J. Clin. Invest., 1927-28, 4: 317-22.—Godel, R., & Chehale, C. Mesure de la vitesse de circulation appliquee k revolution et k la therapeutique des cardiopathies; application d'une methode nouvelle estimant simultanement l'activite circulatoire cardio- pulmonary droite et gauche. Presse med., 1936, 44: 48-50.— Gonzalo, G. R. Lesiones cardfacas y trastornos circulatorios. Siglo med., 1928, 82: 25-7.—Herbst, R. Kalorimetrische Untersuchungen des peripheren Blutstroms an Herzkranken. Verh. Deut. Ges. inn. Med., 1930, 42. Kongr., 250-3.—Hofejsf, J., & Aron, G. Cutanreaktionen der Capillaren auf Adrenalin und Histamin bei Kardiopathien. Zschr. ges. exp. Med., 1936, 99: 17-27.—Masellis, C. I depositi del sangue nei cardiopatici. Boll. Soc. ital. biol. sper., 1939, 14: 378.—Mincuzzi, G. I depositi di sangue nei cardiopatici compensati. Cuore & circol., 1936, 20: 622-35.—Steinmann, B. Ueber das Verhalten des zirkulierenden Blutes beim Herzkranken. Arch. exp. Path., Lpz., 1939, 193: 24-33. ---- Blood pressure. Bishop, L. F. Heart disease and blood-pres- sure. 2. ed. 120p. 8? N. Y., 1907. Bassi, M. La pressione arteriosa agli _ arti_ superiori ed inferiori nei soggetti normali e nei diversi vizi di cuore. Riv. HEART DISEASE 262 HEART DISEASE clin. med.. 1934, 35: 823-48.—Blatny, J. [Determination of blood pressure; blond pressure in cardiopathy] Cas. lek. Cesk., 1922, 61: 72; 89 Rullrirh, R. A., Repetto, R., & Monti, R. A. Las variaciones posturales de las presiones arterial y venosa y de la velocidad circulatona; su influencia en los accidentes de decfibito en los cardlacos. Prensa med. argent., 1941, 28: pt 2, 1958-63.—Frey, J. La relaci6n entre la presi6n del Hquido cefalo-iaquldeo y de la sangre venosa en las enfermedades del coraz6n derecho. Rev. med. aliment., Santiago, 1935-37, 2: 229-32.—Kabanow, N. Der Blutdruck bei Herzkranken Wien. med. Wschr., 1935, 85: 992; 1024.—Kroschinski, E. Blutdruck als Erkennungsmittel des anatomischen Herzbe- fundes. Munch, med. Wschr., 1926, 73: 1442—Lian, C Lambin, P., & Pautrat, J. Etude experimentale des variations des pressions arterielles maxima, moyenne et minima, en fonc- tion du debit cardiaque. C. rend. Soc. biol., 1932, 110: 926 — Meyer, J., & Mullen, T. F. Systolic blood pressure in cardiac decompensation and during compensation. Am. Heart J., 1927-28, 3: 356-9.—Wilson, T. S. A case illustrating the value of the sphygmomanometer in cardiac diagnosis. Lancet, Lond., 1926, 1: 906. ---- Body constitution. Kabanow, N. La constitution chez les cardiaques. Rev. med.. Par., 1936, 53: 326-54.—Pearl, R., & Ciocco, A. Studies on constitution; somatological differences associated with diseases of the heart in white males. Human Biol., 1934, 6: 650-713, pl. Also Collect. Papers Dep. Biol. Johns Hopkins, 1935, 11: No. 13.—Sani, A. L'astenia dei cardiaci. Rass. clin. ter., 1933, 32: 115-7.—Scala, G. Some constitutionalistic criteria in cardiac physiopathology. Sc. Ther., Lewist., 1926- 27, 4: 71-3. ---- Casuistics. Brooks, H. Three cardiac cases. Med. Clin. N. America, 1934, 17: 1141-57.— Cabot. R. C. A cardiac case. Boston M. & S. J., 1927, 197: (19-73.—Cech, A. [Three cases of rare affections of the heart] (as. lek. eesk., 1937, 76: 1333-5 — Gad. A heart case for discussion. J. Egypt. M. Ass., 1933, 16: 483-97.—Jaflfe, R. Demonstrationen zur Herzpathologie. Med. Klin., Berl., 1926, 22: 1782 Lambert, G. Some cardiac cases presenting features of interest. Rep. R. Berkshire Hosp., 1934—35, 62-76.—Mark. H. Cardiac cases admitted recently. J. Lancet, 1936, 56: 344-6. ---- Chemistry. See also subheading Metabolism. Bang, O. [Clinical examination of ether-soluble serums in the blood in heart diseases] Ugeskr. lseger, 1933, 95: 1360-4.—■ Burger, W. Untersuchungen iiber den Ionengehalt des Blutes bei Herzkranken. Deut. Arch. klin. Med., 1928, 159: 79-84.— De Simone, G. II Ph del plasma sanguigno nelle caridopatie dell'infanzia. Med. ital., 1929, 10: 453-60.—Giordano, B. P. Sul comportamento e sul significato della reazione di Hijmans van den Berg nei cardiopazienti. Arch. sc. med., Tor., 1936, 62: 81-96.—Healy, J. C, & Baker, H. Blood catalase in heart disease. J. Lab. Clin. M., 1933, 19: 133-41.—Lazaris, A. L'equilibre proteique du serum sanguin chez les cardiaques. Arch. mal. cceur, 1938, 31: 204-16.—Loeper, M., Mahoudeau, D., & Tonnet, J. L'oxaiemie des cardiaques. Bull. Soc. med. hop. Paris, 1934, 3. ser., 50: 88-91.—Mangun, G. H., Reichle, H. S., & Myers, V. C. Further studies on human cardiac and voluntary muscle; possible implications of changes in the creatine, phosphorus and potassium content, with special reference to heart disease. Arch. Int. M., 1941, 67: 320-32.— Payne, S. A., & Peters, J. P. The plasma proteins in relation to blood hvdration; serum proteins in heart disease. J. Clin. Invest., "1932, 11: 103-12.—Schmitt, F., & Basse, W. Der Mineralgehalt von Plasma und Erythrocyten Herzkranker und seine Beeinflussung durch Pharmaca. Deut. Arch. klin. Med., 1937, 180: 32-9.—Vizer, T. [Hydrogen-ion concentration in heart diseases] Budapesti orv. ujs. 1932, 30: 1111-3.— Vovsy, M. [Examination of bilirubin in blood in diseases of the heart] Vrach. delo, 1926, 9: 24-9.—Yanof, Z. A. Blood pyruvic acid in heart disease. Proc. Soc. Exp. Biol., N. Y., 1941, 47: 516-8. ---- chronic. Patella, V. Del nitrito d'amile nei tratta- mento del periodo dissistolico delle cardiopatie croniche. 56p. 22cm. Padova, 1884. Christian, H. A. Chronic nonvalvular disease of the heart. J. Am. M. Ass., 1928, 91: 549-52. ------ Chronic non-val- vular heart disease; its causes, diagnosis and management. Med. Insur., 1930, 46: 1-4. Also California West. M., 1930. 32: 320-2.—De la Chapelle, C. E. Chronic heart diseases; diagnosis and treatment. N. York State J. M., 1940, 40: 1638- 48. Also repr.—Eyster, J. A. Chronic heart disease. Wiscon- sin M. J., 1926, 25: 165-8— Fahrenkamp, K. Die hausarztliche Hehandlung des chronisch Herzkranken. Med. Welt, 1927, 1: 1700; 1737.—Franke, M. [Chronic heart disease, treatment] Polska gaz. lek., 1926, 5: 841-5.—Luton, S. The treatment of chronic heart disease. J. Missouri M. Ass., 1930, 27: 444-9.— Nonnenbrurh. W. Das Krankenhaus und der chronisch Herz- kranke. No-okomeion, Stuttg., 1936, 7: 211-6.—Todd, A. T. The treatment of chronic heart disease. Med. Press & Circ Lond., 1938, 196: 317-22. ---- Classification. Bainton, J. H., Munly, W. C. [et al.] Criteria for the classification and diagnosis of heart dis- ease. 92p. 8? N. Y., 1928. New York Tuberculosis and Health Asso- ciation. Criteria for the classification and diag- nosis of heart disease. 3. ed. 131p. 8? N. Y., 1932. Baugh, D. D. Cardinal points in the diagnosis and classifi- cation of heart disease. Mississippi Doctor, 1938-39, 16: No. 2, 9-12.—Christian, H. A. Some undesirable tendencies in using an etiological classification of heart disease. N. England J. M., 1933, 209: 444-6.—Cohn, A. E. Statistical studies bearing on problems in the classification of heart diseases; introduction. Am. Heart J., 1925-26, 1: 442-5.—Davis, N. S. The classification of heart disease. Illinois M. J., 1934, 65: 131-4.—Dougherty, J. P. Etiological classification of heart disease. Tr. Luzerne Co. M. Soc. (1924) 1926, 24: 27-9.— Hedley, O. F. The use of etiological nomenclature of heart disease in hospitals in the United States. Am. Heart J., 1936, 12: 129-36.—Huchard, H. Cardiopathies chroniques endo- cardiques et cardiopathies arterielles. Rev. gin. clin. ther., 1907, 21: 387-93.—Nomenclature (A) for cardiac diagnosis. Am. Heart J., 1926-27, 2: 202-6.—Robb, R. C. Criteria for the classification of heart disease. M. & S. Yearb. Physicians Hosp. Pittsburgh, 1929, 1: 122-4, 2 pl.—Stubbs, L. E. The classification and etiology of heart disease. Virginia M. Month., 1934, 61: 458-61.—Wilson, M. G., Lingg, C, & Croxford, G. Statistical studies bearing on problems in the classification of heart disease; heart disease in children. Am, Heart J., 1928-29, 4: 164-96, 2 ch. Also repr.—Zhitnikov, B. A. [Classification of diseases of the heart] Sovet. vrach. gaz., 1933, 37: 887. ---- Clinical aspect. Willius, F. A. Cardiac clinics. 276p. 25cm. S. Louis, 1941. Abrahams, R. Cardiac miscellany. Am. Med., 1931, 26: 141-5.—Annual symposium on heart disease. California West. M., 1940, 53: 193. Also Week. Bull. California Dep. Pub. Health, 1940-41, 19: 157.—Arrilaga, F. C. A prop6sito de un cardiaco. Dfa med. urug: 1934, 2: 279-82.—Ball, W. J. Heart disease; pathological conference. J. S. Carolina M. Ass., 1941, 37: 286-8.—Barth, K. Ein praktischer Wegweiser bei der Untersuchung und Behandlung Herzkranker. Miinch. med. Wschr., 1932, 79: 1109.—Berghoff, R. S. Common types of heart disease. Indust. M., 1940, 9: 235-40.—Biaggi, L. Colloquii tenuti con alcuni suoi amici intorno alle malattie del cuore. Mem. med. contemp., Venez., 1846, 15: 246- 351.—Bierring, W. L. Heart disease and the general practi- tioner. Colorado M., 1934, 31: 372-6.— Bohan, P. T. The clinical picture of heart disease. J. Missouri M. Ass., 1931, 28: 470-4.—Cabot, R. C. An important consideration in the analysis and management of heart trouble; 4 cases. N. Eng- land M. J., 1928, 199: 148-51— Cardiac clinic. South. M. & S., 1940, 102: 452-4.—De la Chapelle, C. E. Heart clinic. Inter- nat. Clin., 1938, n. ser., 3: 246-53, 9 pl. Also repr.—Fazekas, I. [Study of heart diseases] Budapesti orv. ujs., 1931, 29: 859-62.—Ferrannini, L. Lezione di chiusura dell'anno 1935-36. Fol. med., Nap., 1936, 22: 682-98.—Giovannetti, H. A. Clini- cal aphorisms. Nova Scotia M. Bull., 1940, 19: 446.—Gladtke, M. Zur Klinik der Herzkrankheiten. Ther. Gegenwart, 1936, 77: 505-9.—Hale, G. C. The heart and the general practitioner. Canad. M. Ass. J., 1930, 22: 523-6.—Hasenfeld, A. Ueber einige Fragen der Diagnostik, Klinik und Therapie der Herzkrankheiten. Med. Klin., Berl., 1927, 23: 1679-85.— Herrick, J. B. Some of the more favorable features of heart disease. J. Indiana M. Ass., 1927, 20: 247-51.—Hochrein, M. [Clinical aspect of diseases of the heart] Bratisl. lek. listy, 1934, 14: 461-7.—Hunter, M. W. Some common conditions affecting the heart. N. Orleans M. & S. J., 1937, 90: 334-8.— Kelly, G. Some notes on clinical heart disease. Ind. M. Gaz., 1939, 74: 129; 1940, 75: 709.— Koranyi, S. A. Ueber einige Probleme der Klinik der Herzkrankheiten. Zschr. arztl. Fortbild., 1927, 24: 309-13.—Levine, S. A. Some unproved impressions concerning the subject of heart disease. N. Eng- land J. M., 1928, 198: 885-7. ------ Organic heart disease; clinic. Nebraska M. J., 1940, 25: 209-12.— Lineberry, E. D. Cardiac disease in general practice. J. M. Ass. Alabama, 1934-35, 4: 272-8.— Luten, D. Clinic of heart disease. South- west. M., 1928, 12: 446-50.—Minor, J. Present day concepts of heart disease. South. M. J., 1926, 19: 14-8.—Murfee, J. A. Heart disease in general practice. Mississippi Doctor, 1941 42, 19: 251-5.—Myers, M. M. Clinic on diseases of the heart. J. Lancet, 1926, 46: 475-80.—Nesbitt, G. E. Plain facts about hearts. S. Afr. M. J., 1932, 6: 553.—Nuckols, O. P. Medical melange. Kentucky M. J., 1934, 32: 324-8.—Parsons- Smith, B. T. Various phases of heart disease. Postgrad. M. J., Lond., 1926-27, 2: 106-8.—Porter, J. M. The changing concept of heart disease. J. Kansas M. Soc, 1935, 36: 50-6.— Preble, R. B. Generalizations concerning heart disease. Illinois M. J., 1934, 66: 219-23.—Robertson, W. E. Clinical aspects of heart disease, including treatment. Pennsylvania M. J., 1935-36, 39: 140.—Schwarzmann, J. Ueber einige Pragen der Diagnostik, Klinik und Therapie der Herzkrank- HEART DISEASE 263 HEART DISEASE heiten. Munch, med. Wschr., 1928, 75: 482—Silva, C. C. de. Heart disease in general practice. J. Ceylon Brit. M. Ass., 1939, 36: 199-203.—Stilson, W. L. The doctor looks into your heart. Health, Mount. View, 1941, 8: 9.—Whishaw, R. Notes on some modern ideas in heart disease. Med. J. Aus- tralia, 1936, 2: 108-16.—Willius, F. A. A series of cardiac clinics. Proc. Mayo Clin., 1934, 9:535. ------ The considera- tion of certain less common forms of heart disease. Virginia M. Month., 1935-36, 62: 362-6. ---- Complication. Gallavardin, L. Cardiopathies complexes. J. med. Lyon, 1937, 18: 489-92.—Levine, S. A. Heart disease and its com- plications resembling surgical conditions. In Med. Leaves (J. C. Beck) Chic, 1937, 97-100.— Rubensohn. Die Spat- folgen eines Herzleidens (zur Frage der Dienstbeschadigung) Med. Klin., Berl., 1928, 24: 1912-4.— Steuer, L. G. Embolism and thrombosis of large branches of the pulmonary artery in heart disease. J. Lab. Clin. M., 1933, 19: 265-8.—Straehley, C. J. Emboli of cardiac origin.' J. Med., Cincin., 1928-29, 9: 163-8.—Willius, F. A. Embolic manifestations of heart disease. J. Iowa State M. Soc, 1926, 16: 437-40. --- congenital. See also Heart, Abnormity; also under proper names as Foramen oval, patent, &c. Abbott, M. E. S. Atlas of congenital cardiac disease. 62p. fol. N. Y., 1936. Brown, J. W. Congenital heart disease. 255p. 22cm. Lond., 1939. Stancanelli, G. Le malattie congenite di cuore. 460p. 8? Nap., 1936. Abbott, M. E. S. The clinical aspects of congenital cardiac disease; special features. Mod. Concepts Card. Dis., 1936, 5: No. 4, 1.—Acuna, M., & Puglise, A. Cardiopatfas congeni- tas. Actas Congr. nac. med., Rosario, 1934, 5: pt 4, 1247-51. Also Arch, argent, pediat., 1935, 6: 21; 69.—Ambrosio, A. Di un caso di cardiopatia congenita. Studium, Nap., 1936, 26: 265-71.—Antal, E. [Congenital heart disease in athletes] Magy. rontg. kozl., 1937, 11: 54; 79.—Avramov, P. [Con- genital heart diseases in adults] Vrach. gaz., 1927, 31: 1419- 21.—Bach, F. A case of congenital morbus cordis; studied over a period of 12 years. Lancet, Lond., 1928, 1: 1009-11. ----- Congenital heart disease. Med. Press & Circ, Lond., 1934, 189: 262-8.—Baraffa, L. Contributo alia conoscenza delle cardiopatie congenite. Diagnosi, 1931, 11: 93-122, 4 pl.—Bedford, D. E., & Brown, J. W. Congenital diseases (heart) In Brit. Encycl. M. Pract. (Rolleston, H.) Lond., 1937, 6: 206-33.—Bizzarri, A. Contributo casistico di cardio- patie congenite in adulti. Cuore & circol., 1929, 13: 492-506.— Bohan, P. T. Congenital heart lesions. Proc. Interst. Postgrad. M. Ass. N. America (1927) 1928, 3: 110-4.—Box well, W. Congenital heart disease. Irish J. M. Sc. 1941, 6. Ser., No. 189, 540.—Calandra, J. A., & Morano Brandi, J. F. Cardio- pathlas congenitas. Sem. med., B. Air., 1936, 43: 321-34.— Chevalier, H., & Duret, M. Les affections congenitales du coeur. Gaz. hop., 1938, 111: 237; 269; 301.—Clifford, F. C. Congenital ^eart disease. Ohio M. J., 1939, 35: 1181.— Congenital heart disease. Roche Rev., Nutley, N. J., 1937-38, 2: 7-10. Also S. Mary Hosp. Gaz., Lond., 1938, 44: 109-13 — Covey, G. W., & Neely, J. M. Congenital heart disease; report of 3 cases. Nebraska M. J., 1934, 19: 204-11.—Fenn, G. K., & Johnson, C. A. Congenital heart disease. Med. Clin. N. America, 1932, 16: 293.—Figdor, P. Congenital heart disease. Proc. R. Soc. M., Lond., 1927-28, 21: Sect. Clin., 64.—Filgueiras, E., & Fialho, A. Un cas de cardiopathie congenitale sans souffle. Rev. fr. pediat., 1937, 13: 192-203.— Glesne, O. N. Congenital heart disease. J. Iowa M. Soc, 1935, 25: 79.—Goldsmith, M. A. Congenital heart disease. Pub. Health Nurs., 1940, 32: 675-7.—Guillermin & Duchsal. Un cas d'affection congenitale du coeur. Rev. med. Suisse rom., 1939, 59: 117.—Hanina, T. [Two cases of congenital heart diseases in children] Pediatria, Moskva, 1926, 10: 77-82.—Harris, C. The treatment of a case of congenital heart disease. Practitioner, Lond., 1937, 138: 577-84.— Irvine-Jones, E. I. M. A clinical study of congenital heart disease in childhood. Am. Heart J, 1926-27, 2: 121-38 — Jemma, R. Le cardiopatie congenite. Rinasc. med., 1934, 11: 263-5.—Jenks, H. H. Congenital heart disease in children. Pennsylvania M. J., 1928-29, 32: 749-51.—Kerley, P. Con- genital diseases of the heart. Brit. J. Radiol., 1933, 6: 257-65, 2 pl.—Leanage, D. J. T. Congenital heart disease. J. Ceylon Brit. M. Ass., 1938, 35: 446-8.—Leech, C. B. Congenital heart disease; clinical analysis of 75 cases from the Johns Hopkins Hospital. J. Pediat., S. Louis, 1935, 7: 802-39 — Londres, G., de Lima F., A., & de Senna, M. Sopro circular de Miguel Couto em cardiopatia congenita. J. clin., Rio, 1934, 15: 347-55.—McCulloch, H. Congenital heart disease. Mod. Concepts Card. Dis., 1932, 1: 1.—Martinez de la Cruz, F. Afecciones congenitas del coraz6n. Bol. Col. med. Camagiiey, 1941-42, 4: 48-54.—Mendelson, C. L., & Pardee, H. E. B. Congenital heart disease during pregnancy. Am. J. M. Sc, 1941, 202: 392-402.—Mercati, E. Contributo alio studio delle cardiopatie congenite nell'infanzia. Pediat. prat., Mod., 1934, 11: 217-40.—Miller, R. Congenital heart disease. Lancet, Lond., 1936, 1: 1197.—Moncrieff, A. Three specimens of congenital heart disease. Proc R. Soc. M., Lond., 1929-30, 23: Sect. Stud. Dis. Child., 2-4.—Montero Sierra, B. Cinco casos de cardiopatfas congenitas. Rev. chilena pediat., 1940 11: 653-61.—Muir, D. C, & Brown, J. W. Congenital heart disease. Brit. M. J., 1935, 1: 966-71.—Munoyerro Pretel. Cardiopatfas congenitas. Med. ibera, 1936, 30: 512.—Odinet, J. Les cardiopathies congenitales. Progr. med., Par., 1936, 2017-23. Also Union med. Canada, 1939, 68: 614-23.— O'Farrell, P. T. Congenital heart disease in general practice. Irish J. M. Sc, 1939, 6. ser., No. 165, 645-8.—Perry, C. B. Congenital heart disease as seen in elementary school children. Bristol Med. Chir. J., 1931, 48: 41-50. ------ East, T. [et al.] Discussion on the course and management of congenital heart disease. Proc. R. Soc. M., Lond., 1936-37, 30: 693-700. —---- Congenital heart disease. Lancet, Lond., 1937, 1: 324.—Read, W. T., jr, & Krumbhaar, E. B. Eight cases of congenital heart disease. Stud. Dep. Path. Univ. Pennsylvania, 1932-33, 4: Art. 34.—Rodrigues Ferreira, A. L. O coracao congenito. Rev. clin. S. Paulo, 1941, 9: 65-103.—Sebastini, E. Cardiopatia congenita in gravidanza. Riv. ostet. gin., 1933, 15: 450-5.—Solovioff, B. Congenital heart disease. Marquette M. Rev., 1940-41, 5: 127-33.—Sprague, H. B. Congenital heart disease. N. England J. M., 1932, 207: 525.—Stancanelli, G. Contributo statistico clinico alia conoscenza delle malattie di cuore con particolare riferimento alle congenite. Pediatria (Riv.) 1935, 43: 1105-24.—Starling, H. J. Congenital heart disease. Proc. R. Soc. M., Lond., 1929-30, 23: Sect. Dis. Child., 106.—Uguccione, V. Contributo alia casistica delle cardiopatie congenite con speciale riguardo alia loro importanza nei campo della medicina scolastica. Pediatria (Riv.) 1930, 38: 881-98.—Valledor, T. Sobre once casos de cardiopatias con- genitas. Vida nueva, Habana, 1927, 19: 23-30.—Velasco Blanco, L., & Monferini, E. Afecciones congenitas del coraz6n en la infancia. Arch. amer. med., B. Air., 1930, 6: 3-14.—■ Wedd, A. M. Congenital heart disease in adult life. Clifton M. Bull., 1930-31, 16: 141-56, 3 pl.—Weiss, E. The influence of congenital and hereditary factors in diseases of adults; a clinical consideration of congenital heart disease. Atlantic M. J., 1925-26, 29: 677-81.—Werley, G. Some clinical aspects of congenital heart disease. Southwest. M., 1927, 11: 387-9.— Zenoni, C. Di alcune rare affezioni congenite del cuore. Riv. med., 1928, 36: 161-5. ---- congenital: Complication. See also Heart failure, congenital. Cohen & Maryssael, L. A propos d'un cas d'affection hemo- lytique accompagnee d'une maladie congenitale du cceur. Bruxelles med., 1939-40, 20: 534-7.—D'Ambrosio, R. Cardio- patie congenite e tubercolosi polmonare negli adulti. Lotta tuberc, 1939, 10: 734-47.—Davison, C, & Weiss, M. M. Muscular hypotonia associated with congenital heart disease. Am. J. Dis. Child., 1929, 37: 359-66.—Fabris, A. Intorno a un caso di cardiopatia congenita e tubercolosi polmonare ematogena. Cuore & circol., 1932, 16: 585-93.—Hanna, R. Cerebral abscess and paradoxic embolism associated with congenital heart disease; report of 7 cases, with a review of the literature. Am. J. Dis. Child., 1941, 62: 555-67.—Hawk, W. A. Congenital heart disease and intracranial haemorrhage. Univ. Toronto M. J., 1929-30, 7: 9-16.—O'Reilly, J. N. Pulmonary conditions and congenital heart diseases in the new-born. Med. Press & Circ, Lond., 1935, 191: No. 5033, Suppl., p. xiv-xvii.—Ross, M. Mental retardation associated with congenital heart disease; a study of 22 cases. J. Pediat., S. Louis, 1939, 14: 21-4.—Wall, A case of congenital morbus cordis complicated by pulmonary tuberculosis. Brompton Hosp. Rep., Lond., 1934, 3: 150. ---- congenital: Diagnosis and prognosis. Haroen, I. L. *Diagnose en prognose van aangeboren hartgebreken. 92p. 8? Amst., 1932. Mannheimer, E. Calibrated phonocardi- ography and electrocardiography; a clinical statistical study of normal children and children with congenital heart disease. 287p. 24}£cm. Stockh., 1940. Schnitker, M. A. The electrocardiogram in congenital cardiac disease. 147p. 24J4cm. Cambr., Mass., 1940. Abbott, M. E. Clinical lecture on the differential diagnosis of congenital cardiac disease. Internat. Clin., Phila., 1934, 44. ser., 3: 15-45, 7 pl. Also repr.—Arkoussky, J. [Radiodiagnosis of congenital heart diseases] Vest, rentg., 1926, 4: 95-108.— Ash, R., & Harshaw, E., jr. Congenital heart disease in child- hood, with special reference to prognosis. Am. Heart J., 1939, 18: 80-8. Also repr. Also Mod. Concepts Card. Dis., 1941, 10; i.—Battro, A., & Quirno, N. El electrocardiograma en diversas cardiopatias congenitas. Rev. argent, card., 1935-36, 2: 335-53.—Buschuiev, V. [Diagnostic importance of teeth in congenital cardiac diseases in adult persons] Vrach. gaz., 1927, 31: 1425-31.—Cossio, P., Arana, R. [et al.] Cardiopatfas congenitas; diagn6stico clinico. Sem. med., B. Air., 1938, 45: pt 2, 364-71.—Dippel, A. L. Two cases of congenital heart disease in which the diagnosis was made before birth. Am. J. HEART DISEASE 264 HEART DISEASE Obst., 1934, 27: 120-3.—Dry. T. J. An approach to the diag- nosis of congenital heart disease. Am. Heart J., 1937, 14: 135- 54. ------ Essentials in the diagnosis of congenital heart disease. Minnesota M., 1939, 22: 78-89. ------ A talk on the essentials in the diagnosis of congenital heart disease. Proc. Mayo Clin., 1939, 14: 605-8. ——— The essentials in the diagnosis of congenital heart disease. In Card. Clinics (Willius, F. A.) S. Louis, 1941, 159-53.—Eisenberg, G., & Gibson, S. Congenital heart disease and the electrocardiogram. J. Pediat., S. Louis, 1941, 19: 452-69.—Fornara, P., & Zibordi, F. Le cardiopatie congenite nell'infanzia (con speciale riguardo ai metodi di indagine) Clin, igiene inf., 1929, 4: 617.—;Fornara, P. Cenni di semeiotica cardiologica infantile (preliminari alio studio delle cardiopatie congenite) Clin, pediat., Mod., 1929, 11: 995-1030. ------ Zibordi, F. [et al.] Le cardiopatie congenite nell'infanzia (con speciale riguardo ai metodi d'inda- gine) Pediatria (Riv.) 1929, 37: 1127-35. Also Pensiero med., 1929, 18: 866-8.—Friedman, J. The corgenital heart; a radio- logic study, with 7 reported cases. Radiology, 1937, 28: 466- 72.—Hoshi, N. The clinical observation of congenital cardiac diseases; examination by X-ray and electrocardiogram. J. Orient. M., Dairen, 1930, 13: 33.—Lagransky, A. S. [Diagnosis of hidden congenital diseases of the heart] Klin, med., Moskva, 1933, 11: 203-8.—Laubry, C, & Souli6, P. Troubles de rythme sinusal et de la conductibilite auriculo-ventriculaire au cours des maladies congenitales du coeur. Rev. med., Par., 1939, 56: 87-103. ------& Vincent, P. Troubles du rythme sinusal et de la conductibilite auriculo-ventriculaire dans 2 cas de maladie congenitale du coeur. Arch. mal. cceur, 1938, 31: 1-10.— Letondal, P. Diagnostic des cardiopathies congenitales de la premidre enfance. Union med. Canada, 1937, 66: 535-7.— McGinn, S., & White, P. D. Progress in the recognition of congenital heart disease. N. England J. M., 1936, 214: 763- 8.—Maraczi, J. [Diagnostic possibilities in cases of congenital heart diseases] Orvoskepzes, 1935, 25: oct. kiilonf. (L. Ketly Festschr.) 201-5.—Morlock, H. V. Congenital lesion of heart or pericardium. Proc. R. Soc. M., Lond., 1934-35, 28: 759 — Mouquin, M., & Jouvel, J. Les faux diagnostics de cardio- pathie congenitale chez l'enfant. J. med. Paris, 1930, 50: 486-9. Also Med. inf., Par., 1930, 37: 103-16.—Mouquin, M., & Louvel. J. Les faux diagnostics de cardiopathie congenitale chez l'enfant. Bull, med., Par., 1930, 44: 128-31—O'Farrell, P. T. The clinical diagnosis of congenital heart disease. Irish J. M. Sc, 1938, 6. ser., No. 153, 597-613.—Pendergrass, E. P., & Allen, M. L. Congenital cardiac disease in infants with a discussion of tracheal displacement as a roentgen sign. Am. J. Roentg., 1934, 31: 470-81—P6rez de los Reyes, R., & De La Torre, H. Diagn6stico actual de las cardiopatias congenitas. Bol. Soc. cubana pediat., 1938, 10: 293-307.—Pezzi, C, & Agostoni, G. Studio clinico e radiologico di un caso di malattia congenita del cuore. Atti Soc. lombard. sc. med., 1926, 15: 119-28.—Richards, D. W., jr. Congenital heart disease; measurements of the circulation. Arch. Int. M., 1931, 47: 484-99. Also repr.—Roberts, J. T. The diagnosis of congenital heart disease before birth and the hereditary factor in congenital heart disease. J. Techn. Meth., Toronto, 1938, 18: 101-5.— Rochlin, D., & Arkussky, J. [Differentiation of the organism and in particular, of the osseous system in congenital heart disease] Vrach. gaz., 1928, 32: 819-22.—Roulier, D., Brumlik, J., & Malinsky, A. De 1'eiectrocardiogramme dans les cardio- pathies congenitales; allongement dela duteede l'onde rapide et block de branche droite. Arch. mal. coeur, 1940, 33: 40-9.— S0ndergaard, K. [Roentgen diagnosis of congenital heart disease] Hospitalstidende, 1933, 76: [Dansk. radiol. selsk.] 51-3.—Sokolova-Panomareva, O. [Diagnosis of children's congenital heart diseases] Omsky med. J., 1926, 1: 2; 50.— Soriani, I. L'elettrocardiogramma nelle malattie congenite del cuore nei bambini. Clin, pediat., Mod., 1930, 12: 647-700, 20 pl.—Taylor, F. R. The differential diagnosis of congenital heart diseases and allied conditions. South. M. & S., 1933, 95: 491-5.—Weiss, E. The differential diagnosis of congenital heart disease. Med. Clin. N. America, 1926, 10: 185-98. ---- congenital: Etiology. Lotjvet, E. *Du role de la syphilis dans les cardiopathies congenitales. 63p. 8? Par., 1929. Alix y Alix, J. Cardiopatia famiUar y tuberculosis. Arch. med., Madr., 1933, 36: 1245-7.—Atenzi Tedesco, P. Su due casi di cardiopatia congenita familiare. Cuore & circol., 1933, 17: 76-93.—Babonneix, L„ & Delarue. Lesions cardiaques congenitales en rapport avec l'heredo-syphilis. Gaz. hop 1928, 101: 441.—Carloni, G. Sulla frequenza delle cardio- patie congenite osservate in un quinquennio presso la Clinica pediatrica di CagUari. Pediat. prat., Mod., 1934,11:411-5.— Cohen, S. A. Congenital heart disease with special reference to its etiology. Med. CUn. N. America, 1932, 15: 1295-312.— Ellis, R. W. B. Congenital morbus cordis in 2 sisters. Proc R. Soc. M., Lond., 1933, 26: 511. Also Brit. J. Child. Dis., 1936, 33: 286-8.—Evans, T. I. An investigation into congenital heart disease with especial reference to its relationship to rheumatism in the parent. Pub. Health, Lond., 1936-37, 50: 387-9.—Grenet, H. Affections congenitales du cceur et heredo-syphilis. Gaz. hdp., 1930, 103: 37-40. ------ Les affections congenitales du coeur; les cardiopathies congenitales sans cyanose; etiologie des cardiopathies congenitales; indica- tions therapeutiques. In his Conf. clin. med. inf., Par 1933 2. ser., 173-91.—Hecht, H., & Gupta, I. C. Elektrokardh> gramm und Vererbung. Deut. Arch. klin. Med., 1937-38, 181: 160-80.—Kennedy. W. P. Morbidity in a family tree Brit. M. J., 1934, 2: 630.—Macera, J. M., & Puchelli, A. R. Cardiopatias congenitas; la frecuencia en 10,000 escolares de la capital federal. Dia med., B. Air., 19 10, 12: 628-31. Mussio Fournier, J. C. Instabilite cardiaque familiale. Bull. Soc. med. h6p. Paris, 1932, 3. ser., 48: 1238.—Reid, W. D. The causation and prevention of congenital heart disease. Arch. Int. M., 1931, 48: 721-33.—Roberts, J. T. The incidence of congenital heart disease in the New Orleans Charity Hospital. J. Techn. Meth., Toronto, 1937, 17: 108-13. Also N. Orleans M. & S. J., 1937, 90: 153-5.—Terplan, K., & Sanes, S. The incidence of congenital heart lesions in infancy. J. Techn. Meth., Toronto, 1936, No. 15, 86-95. ---- congenital: Pathology. Mejia Casals, A. L. *Etude statistique des affections cardiaques congenitales. 62p. 8? Par., 1936. Steinhoff, K. *Ueber fetale Endokarditis des linken Herzens. 29p. 8? Berl.; 1937. Abbott, M. E. On the clinical classification of congenital cardiac disease. Lancet, Lond., 1929, 2: 164. Also repr.— Abraham, J. Fetale Endokarditis. Zbl. Gyn., 1937, 61: 2698-703.—Bartak, F. [Fetal endocarditis] Cas. lek. cesk., 1935, 74: 1400-8, 2 pl.—Cams, M. L., Ritchie, G., & Musscr, M. J. An unusual case of congenital heart disease in a woman who lived for 44 years and 6 months. Am. Heart J., 1941, 21: 522-9.—Cossio, P. Cardiopatias congenitas; clasificaci6n clinica. Sem. med., B. Air., 1938, 45: pt 2, 361-4. Also Cuore & circol., 1939, 23: 153-60.—Crawford, R. Congenital heart disease, with presentation of case and pathologic specimens. N. Orleans M. & S. J., 1936-37, 89: 223-7— Di Guglielmo, G. Un caso di complessa cardiopatia congenita. Rass. internaz. clin. ter., 1935, 16: 244-55.—Donat, R. Zur Frage der fotalen Endokarditis. Frankf. Zschr. Path., 1939, 53: 120-7.— Gibson, S., & Clifton, W. M. Congenital heart disease; a clinical and postmortem study of 106 cases. Proc Inst. M. Chicago, 1936, 11: 191. Also Am. J. Dis. Child., 1938, 55: 761-7.—Hallock, P. Lactic acid production during rest and after exercise in subjects with various types of heart disease with special reference to congenital heart disease. J. Clin. Invest., 1939, 18: 385-94.—Hoshi, N. The clinical observa- tion of congenital cardiac diseases; on the classification of clinical types and prognosis. Polyclin. Dairen, 1930-33, 5: No. 5, 8.—Leaman, W. G. Congenital heart disease including report of a case of congenital heart block with autopsy findings. Med. Clin. N. America, 1933, 17: 853-67.—Leech, C. B. Statistics of 75 cases of congenital heart disease at the Johns Hopkins Hospital. J. Techn. Meth., Toronto, 1936, No. 15,101.— bevinson, S. A. Congenital heart disease as a cause of sudden unexpected death in children under 1 year of age. Am. J. Clin. Path., 1941, 11: 741-53.—Lyss, S. Angeborene Herz- krankheit bei plotzhchem Tod. Deut. Zschr. gerichtl. Med., 1939, 31: 248-52.—Mercati, E. Contributo alio studio delle cardiopatie congenite nell'infanzia. Pediat. prat., Mod., 1934, 11: 247-73.—Moschini, S. La velocity di sedimentazione delle emazie nelle cardiopatie congenite. Riv. clin. pediat., 1935, 33: 152-66.—Prinzmetal, M. Calculation of the venous- arterial shunt in congenital heart disease. J. Clin. Invest., 1941, 20: 705-8.—Rabbiosi, V. L'analisi dei gas del sangue nelle cardiopatie congenita. Cuore & circol., 1932, 16: 33-9.— Szypulski, J. T. A study of congenital heart disease at the Philadelphia General Hospital. J.Techn. Meth., Toronto, 1937, 17: 119-26.—Tatafiore, E. Studio clinico, elettrocardiografico ed anatomopatologico su di una rara forma di cardiopatia congenita. Lattante, 1931, 2: 842-64.—Verde, M. La pressione arteriosa nei bambini con cardiopatia congenita. Pediatria (Riv.) 1936, 44: 231-43. ------ Ricerche ema- tologiche in bambini con cardiopatia congenita. Ibid., 580-92. ---- Decompensation. See Heart failure. ---- degenerative. Christoffersen, N. R. [Treatment of chronic degeneration of the heart] Ugeskr. laeger, 1938, 100: 71-80.—Cohn, A. E. The degenerative forms of heart disease. Hosp. Social Serv., 1933, 28: Suppl. No. 2, 56-68.—Cole, H. H. Degenerative heart disease. Illinois M. J., 1933, 63: 156-61.—Kennie, A. T. Abdominal symptoms in degenerative cardiac disease. Glas- gow M. J., 1938, 130: 213-20.—Lambert, A. The action of the autonomic nervous system as an explanation for the thera- peutic value of the carbonic acid baths in degenerative cardiac disease. N. York State J. M., 1935, 35: 147-56.—Stroud, W. D. A proposed familial study of degenerative types of heart disease. M. & S. Yearb. Physicians Hosp. Platteburgh, ---- Diagnosis. See also Heart failure, Test. Kleist, H. W. *Katamnestische Unter- suchungen iiber Herzkranke. 25p. 22y2cm. Freib. i. B., 1936. HEART DISEASE 265 HEART DISEASE Sbrocchi, A. La diagnosi delle malattie del cuore e dell'aorta. 834p. 8? Lanciano [1935] Ulrich [O.] R. *Zur Diagnostik, Prognose und Begutachtung von Herzkrankheiten und ihre Haufung in der letzten 15 Jahren [Leipzig] 24p. 8? Zeulenroda, 1935. Babcock, R. H. The general practitioner and the heart. Memphis M. J., 1926, 3: 41-4.—Bach, F. Investigation of a heart case. Med. Press & Circ, Lond., 1937, 194: 609-12.— Bamber, J. M. A consideration of diagnostic criteria in heart disease. N. Orleans M. & S. J., 1934-35- 87: 538-41.—Barella. Considerations pratiques sur le diagnostic et le traitement des maladies du coeur. Presse med. beige, 1869-70, 22: 397; 405.—Beecher, C. H. The recognition of valvular lesions and cardiac arrhythmias by the general practitioner. M. & S. Yearb. Physicians Hosp. Plattsburgh, 1929, 1: 14-20.— Berghoff, R. S. Epochal heart disease. Med. Clin. N. America, 1932, 16: 303.—Bethea, O. W. Some suggestions in diagnosis. Tr. Am. Ther. Soc, 1937, 37: 63.—Brenner, O. The diagnosis of heart disease, based on a post-graduate demonstration given at the Queens hospital on May 27th. Birmingham M. Rev., 1932, 7: 192-219.—Brown, A. G., jr. Review of 100 cases of heart disease from the diagnostic standpoint. Tr. M. Soc. Virginia, 1916, 46: 44-56.—Campani, A., & Margreth, G. La linea capillare polmonare dei cardiopatici e sua importanza diagnostica. Minerva med., Tor., 1936, 27: 309.—Cherry, S. L. Diagnosis and treatment of some common heart condi- tions. West Virginia M. J., 1933, 29: 164-9.—Clark, C. J. Heart disease; some points in diagnosis. J. Indiana M. Ass., 1939, 32: 403-6.—Cotton, T. F. Modern methods in the diag- nosis and treatment of heart disease. Canad. M. Ass. J., 1926, 16: 487-92. Also Clin. J., Lond., 1926, 55: 589-94 — Da-Riu, O. La sfigmoviscosimetria nei cardiopatici in rap- porto alia funzionalitii cardiaca. Clin. med. ital., 1925, 56: 535-44.—Duncan, C. S. Accessory factors concerned in the diagnosis of heart disease. West Virginia M. J., 1941, 37: 261-3.—Etinger, Y. G. [Diagnosis of combined cardiac defects] Klin, med., Moskva, 1930, 8: 1300-3.—Fischer, R. L. Status of X-ray and other laboratory evaluation of heart disease from an internist's viewpoint. J. Am. Osteopath. Ass., 1941- 42, 41: 139-41.—Gardiner, J. F. The bedside recognition and treatment of cardiac irregularities. Nebraska M. J., 1938, 23: 258-64.—Grant, S. B. Mechanical aids in diagnosis of heart disease. J. Missouri M. Ass., 1931, 28: 477-9.—Greene, C. L., & Borg, J. F. The early diagnosis of heart disease. Minne- sota M., 1929, 12: 684-8.—Halsey, R. H. The advantage of a complete diagnosis in cardiac conditions. N. York State J. M., 1930, 30: 141-5.—Harrison, T. R. Some general princi- ples in the bedside diagnosis of heart disease. South. M. J., 1940, 33: 308-14—Holmes, W. H. Common forms of heart disease; their recognition and treatment. Northwest M., 1936, 35: 79; 142.—Hood, J. G. Standardization of cardiac diagnoses. Med. Bull. Veterans Admin., 1938-39, 15: 380-2.— Hull, E. The diagnosis of heart disease by the general practi- tioner. Tristate M. J., 1932, 5: 986-91.—Hunter, J. W., jr. On the use of instruments of precision in the diagnosis of heart disease. Virginia M. Month., 1932, 58: 743-9.—Jarpe, E. The heart recoil. Acta med. scand., 1934, 83: 369-88.— Kaplan, D. Recording of cardiac findings for rating purposes. U. S. Veterans Bur. M. Bull., 1927, 3: 872-5.—Keating, E. When the cause of heart disease is obscure. Illinois M. J., 1933, 63: 116-20.—Kerr, W. J. Diagnosis of heart disease. Proc Interst. Postgrad. M. Ass. N. America, 1925, 1: 77-81.— Kiser, E. F. Heart disease; its diagnosis and treatment. J. Indiana M. Ass., 1927, 20: 7-13.—Levine, S. A. The bedside recognition and treatment of cardiac irregularities. Internat. Clin., 1936, 46. ser., 4: 162-92.—Little, J. H. Heart and upper abdominal disease; their differential diagnosis. J. M. Ass. Alabama, 1941-42, 11: 155-7.—Maher, C. C. Cardiac diag- nosis. Radiol. Rev., 1937, 59: 85-9.—Martin, B. H. Recogni- tion and valuation of cardiac symptoms and signs from the standpoint of the general practitioner. Virginia M. Month., 1927-28, 54: 367.—Marvel, P., jr. Cardiac irregularities and their clinical recognition. J. M. Soc. N. Jersey, 1931, 28: 903-10.—Milet, C. Sopro circular e sopro cormico; a proposito de um caso clinico. Brasil med., 1937, 51: 7-17.—Miller, C. I., & Tuttle, W. W. A simple method for detecting abnormal hearts. Proc. Soc Exp. Biol., N. Y., 1933, 30: 414.—Mitchell, W. G. Heart disease with especial reference to early diagnosis and treatment. Texas J. M., 1938-39, 34: 541-3.—Morgan, P. The case history in heart disease. J. Kansas M. Soc, 1938, 39: 239—44.—Mut, A. El diagn6stico de las enfermedades del coraz6n sin medios auxiliares. Inform, med., Valladolid, 1933, 10: 211; 239. Also Cr6n. med. mex., 1934, 33: 323-32 — Nesbitt, G. E. Some cardiac cases illustrating the value of graphic methods. Irish J. M. Sc, 1927, 6. ser., 68-75, 4 pl — Pardee, H. E. B. The complete examination of the cardiac patient. In Pract. Lect. (M. Soc. Co. Kings) (1924-26) 1927, 421-33. ------ The importance of the etiology in the diag- nosis of heart disease. Med. Clin. N. America, 1929, 13: 649-66.—Parks, B. S. Some points in the diagnosis of heart disease. West Virginia M. J., 1927, 23: 354-61.—Parmenter, G. H. History and physical examination in the diagnosis of heart disease. U. S. Veterans Bur. M. Bull., 1930, 5: 33-8 — Parreiras, L. Diagnostico precoce das cardiopathias. Fol. med., Rio, 1926, 7: 232.—Peters, J. T. [Diagnosis and treat- ment of heart diseases] Geneesk. gids, 1928, 6: 529-37.— Podolsky, E. Diagnostic hints in heart disease. Med. Rec, N. Y 1941, 153: 26; 120.—Polevski, J. Newer viewpoints in cardiac diagnosis. Med. J. & Rec, 1930, 131: 360-3 Also i"nP„ro^~ T~ Some s?u^eso0f information and misinformation m cardiac diagnosis. J. M. Soc. N. Jersey, 1931, 28: 121-30 — Preble, R. B. Some fundamental facts in the diagnosis'of heart lesions. J. Iowa State M. Soc, 1926, 16: 205-10 — Ri!„ IC ' M'AGi> Cll"ical c"teria for the diagnosis of heart disease. Med. Rec, Houston, 1934, 28: 404-6 —Reid W D io%7lnolP^onr>C1?les of cardiac diagnosis. Boston M. & S.' J " if +v.o i? ! m' j t . t, Table of data Pertaining to diseases of the heart. Med. J. & Rec, 1929, 129: 257.—Russum, B. C Etiological viewpoint in diagnosis of heart disease. Nebraska M. J., 1934 19: 97.—Schnabel, T. G. Clinical evidence justi- &mg, acardlac diagnosis. Med. Clin. N. America, 1928-29 12: 1137-46—Scott, RW. Heart diseases. Proc Interst. Postgrad. M. Ass. N. America, 1932, 7-12.—Shaw, M E Sphygmomanometer in the diagnosis of cardiac irregularities. Brit. M. J., 1933, J: 957.-Shippey, W. L. The recognition and management of the more common cardiac conditions. J Oklahoma M. Ass., 1937, 30: 408-13.—Simpson, R. H., & Batten, L. W. Some points in the diagnosis of cardiac lesions in children Lancet, Lond., 1929, 2: 372-5.—Sonne, C. [Diagnosis of heart diseases] Militaerlaegen, 1930, 36: 81-93 — Stephens, G. A. The early detection of heart trouble. Med Press & Circ, Lond., 1930, 130: 7-9.—Straehley, C. J. Diag- nosis and treatment of common cardiac diseases J Med Cincin., 1931 12: 171-6.—Swineford. O., jr. The phvsieai diagnosis of heart disease; with the aid of diagrams tables and notes. Virginia M. Month., 1930-31, 57: 654-64.— T?y!0,'mJ- D* Some notes on heart for general practitioner. Med. Times, N. Y., 1927, 55: 186; 191.—Thomas, C. R. The bedside diagnosis of cardiac irregularities. J. Tennessee M. Ass., 1938, 31: 255-62.—Vedrani, G. II criterio clinico per diagnosticare la compromissione del cuore nelle infezioni Riv. med., Milano, 1927, 35: 65-8.—Viko, L. E. Heart disease; its modern diagnosis. California West. M., 1930, 32: 78-82.— Waddill, J. F. General considerations in the diagnosis of heart disease. Virginia M. Month., 1938, 65: 131-5.—Warburg, E. [Diagnosis and prognosis of heart diseases] Ugeskr. Iseger, 1932, 94: 249-56.—Weber, A. Fortschritte in der Herz- diagnostik. Med. Welt, 1938, 12: 632-5. ------ Progressos realizados para o diagnostico das enfermidades cardiacas. Med. germ., Rio, 1941-42, 10: 411-21.—Whiting, W. B. Some factors governing the diagnosis of heart disease. Texas J. M., 1935-36, 31: 436-40.—Willius, F. A. Distinction of the normal from the diseased heart. Minnesota M., 1933, 16: 468-73. ----—■ Distinci6n entre el corazon normal y el coraz6n enfermo. Arch. lat. amer. card., Mex., 1933-34, 4: 1-13. ------ Factors concerned in the diagnosis of heart disease. J. Lancet, 1935, 55: 346-50. ------ A comprehen- sive approach to the diagnosis of diseases of the heart. Med. Clin. N. America, 1939, 23: 1007-19.—Wolffe, J. B., & Schu- mann, M. Resume of methods in cardiac diagnosis. Med. Times, N. Y., 1930, 58: 140-4. ---- Diagnosis, differential. Barnes, A. R. Etiologic and pathologic approach to the diagnosis of heart disease. J. Indiana M. Ass., 1933, 26: 373.—Bishop, L. F., jr. Acute indigestion; or is it heart disease? Hygeia, Chic, 1938, 16: 1103-6.—Blackford, L. M. The importance of differential diagnosis in heart disease; report of cases. J. M. Ass. Georgia, 1939, 28: 444-8.—Dunlop, H. A. Heart attacks; real and apparent. Med. Press & Circ, Lond., 1933, 136:46-51.—Dwan, P. F. Heart disease vs. heart trouble. J. Lancet, 1935, 55: 277-80.—Gager, L. T. The differentiation of syphilis and hypertension in the etiologic diagnosis of heart disease. Med. Bull. Veterans Admin., 1939-40, 16: 226-31 — Hassencamp, E. Differentialdiagnose und Therapie der Herzempfindungen. Deut. med. Wschr., 1939, 65: 459; 514.— Hop, W. P. C. [Two pseudo-heart cases] Geneesk. gids, 1935, 13: 535-9.—Horine, E. F. Disease masquerades in heart symptoms. Kentucky M. J., 1938, 36: 313-7.—Mead, W. R. The recognition, differentiation and management of the com- moner cardiac crises. J. S. Carolina M. Ass.. 1937, 33: 281-7.— Schilling, V. Ueber einen als Herzfehler erscheinenden Fall von Innenkorperanamie, aufgedeckt als chronische Anti- febrinvergiftung und Coffeinsucht. Zschr. klin. Med., 1928, 108: 709-36.—Topmoeller, G. B. Upper abdominal conditions simulating heart disease. J. Med., Cincin., 1932, 13: 84-8.—' Willius, F. A. The differential diagnosis of disease of the heart. J. Lancet, 1931, 51: 34—41. —■—■—- Cardiac clinics; a talk on the importance of the taking of an accurate history in the identification and differentiation of lesions. Proc Mayo Clin., 1938, 13: 61. ---- Diagnosis: Errors. See also subheading Manifestation. Chavez, I. Algunos signos de confusi6n frecuentes en clinica cardiol6gica. Arch. lat. amer. card., Mex., 1940, 10: 215-35.—Deneen, F. O. Heart conditions usually unrecog- nized. Illinois M. J., 1927, 52: 325-8.—Eggleston, C. The true and false in cardiac diagnosis. J. M. Soc. N. Jersey, 1938, 35: 484-9.—Ernstene, A. C. Common errors in cardiac diag- nosis. Proc. Interst. Postgrad. M. Ass. N. America (1940) 1941, 89-92. Also Ohio M. J., 1940, 36: 497-500.—Hensel, C. N. Pitfalls in cardiac diagnosis. Minnesota M., 1933, 16: 457-67.—Linnell, J. W., & Thomson, W. A. R. Some cardio- logical fallacies. Brit. M. J., 1938, 2: 442-4.—Mohler, H. K. HEART DISEASE 266 HEART DISEASE Missed cardiac diagnosis. Med. Clin. N. America, 1937, 21: 1003-11.—Mut, A. De algunos errores en la interpretaci6n de las grfficas en cardiologia. Progr. clin., Madr., 1920, 16: 347-53.—Wenckebach, K. F. Herzkranke, die es nicht sind Munch, med. Wschr., 1934, 81: 425-30. Also Wien. med. Wschr., 1934, 84: 621; 650.—Willius, F. A. A talk on certain less common diagnostic pitfalls with reference to cardiac diseases. Proc Mayo Clin., 1939, 14: 4SS-90. ---- Diagnosis: Methods. Benedetti, P., & Bollini, V. Valutazione metrica e ispettiva del cuore dei cardiopazienti. 238p. 4? Bologna, 1936. Also Arch, pat., Bologna, 1935, 15: 131; passim. Benedetti, P. Die klinische Morphologie des Herzens und ihre Auswertungsmethodik bei Herzgesunden und Herz- kranken. Erg. inn. Med. Kinderh., 1936, 51: 531-622.— Biondo, S. L'esame dell'ammalato di cuore; critica e metodo secondo le moderne vedute. Cuore & circol., 1932, 16: 262- 78.—Borgard, W. Zur Beurteilung der Kreislaufleistung beim Herzkranken. Med. Klin., Berl., 1937, 33: 1234-6.—Condo- relli, L. II pneumomediastino nella diagnostica cardiologica. Cardiologia, Basel, 1937, 1: 26-39, pl.—Di Lernia, P. Capil- laroscopia nelle cardiopatie. Policlinico, 1934, 41: sez. med., 192-8.—Dossola, A. A. Importancia de la determinaci6n de la capacidad vital en los enfermos del coraz6n. Med. ibera, 1934, 28: pt 2, 332-12.—Epstein, B. S., & Schwedel, J. B. A correlation of the fluoroscopic, clinical and post-mortem findings in 155 cases of organic heart disease. Am. Heart J., 1938, 15: 317-34.—Joselevich, M. La prueba de la hiper- glucemia provocada en los cardiacos. Sem. med., B. Air., 1931, 38: 1102-12.—Levy, L. [Inspection of cardiac patients] Gy6gy£szat, 1935, 75: 12-4.—Lueth, H. C. Laboratory examinations in heart disease. Am. J. M. Techn., 1938, 4: 162-8.—Macera, J. M., Ruchelli, A., & Gaig, R. Estudio clinico, electrocardiogr&fico, telerradiogrdfico, fonocardio- griifico y de orientaci6n profesional. Sem. med., B. Air., 1940, 47: 983-97.—Melkikh, B. M., & Fedorova, L. M. [Clinical significance of determining the blood volume in heart diseases] Klin, med., Moskva, 1938, 16: 350-4.—Neurath, O. Clinical aids in the diagnosis of heart diseases in general practice. J. Iowa M. Soc, 1941, 31: 426-30.—Olmsted. H. C. Intra- dermal salt solution test in cardiac disease in children. Arch. Int. M., 1926, 37: 281-90. Also repr.—Ortner, N. Vagus- oder Karotis-Druckversuch? Med. Klin., Berl., 1926, 22: 570.—Osgood, E. E. Physical diagnosis in heart disease. Northwest M., 1939, 38: 160-4. Also repr.—Richard, G. Un nouveau moyen d'etude des reactions des petites arteres: l'epreuve de denivellation. Arch. mal. cceur, 1921, 14: 316- 26.—Smagin, G. A. [Diagnostic and prognostic value of func- tional examination of a diseased heart] Sovet. vrach. gaz., 1932, 80-6.—Troitsky, N. V. [Respiration test for children in diseases of the heart] Ibid., 1934, 38: 39-42.—Villa, L. Osservazioni a proposito di un articolo estero sulla pesata dei cardiaci quale metodo di indagine funzionale dei cuore. Cuore & circol., 1926, 10: 299-302.—Wood, F. C, & Wolferth, C. C. The tolerance of certain cardiac patients for various recumbent positions (trepopnea) Am. J. M. Sc, 1937, 193: 354-78. ---- Digestive system. AmuchXstegui, S. R. *Estudio funcional del hfgado afectado por el estancamiento sangufneo en la cardiopatfas. 166p. 24cm. C6rdoba, 1936. Bologna, A., & Costadoni, A. Osservazioni sulle funzione gastro-pancreatica nei cardiopazienti. Arch. ital. mal. app. diger., 1938, 7: 215-54.—Delia, A. Funzionalite gastrica nei cardiopazienti. Clin. med. ital., 1938, 69: 733-46.—Flaxman, N. Gastro-intestinal manifestations of heart disease. Am. J. Digest. Dis., 1941, 8: 10-3.—Fornet, B. [Liver of cardiac patients] Orvoskepzes, 1938, 28: 542-7.—Gerlei, F. [Cardiac diseases due to changes in the pancreas] Orv. hetil., 1929, 73: 1288-92. Also Virchows Arch., 1930, 276: 148-62.—Hargrove, M. D. The interrelationship of gastrointestinal and cardiac disease. N. Orleans M. & S. J., 1941-42, 94: 111-6.— Herman, K. Herz und Magen. Munch, med. Wschr., 1936, 83: 1716- 8.—Hurxthal, L. M. Gastro-intestinal symptoms in patients with heart disease. Surg. Clin. N. America, 1937, 17: 721-4;— Levitan & Alexeief-Berkman. Digestion chez les malades porteurs des lesions cardiaques, selon les regimes alimentaires Arch. mal. app. digest., 1935, 25: 162-79.—Meldolesi, g! Die pulsatorischen Bewegungen des Oesophagus bei der physiologLschen und pathologischen Herztatigkeit (klinisch- rontgenologische Beobachtungen) Wien. med. Wschr., 1926, 76: 1115-21.—Ramos, J., & Oria, J. Clinica e histo-patologia do coracao em portadores de megaesofago e megacolo. Arq cir. clin. exp., S. Paulo, 1940, 4: 363-442.—Schwedel, J. B., & Gutman, E. B. The esophagus in disease of the heart and aorta; case report with roentgen and post-mortem findings. Am j' Roentg., 1935. 34: 164-7.—Smith, T. M. Report of a case of heart disease with terminal intestinal perforation. J. Nat M A38., N. Y., 1938, 30: 58-62.—Sokolnikov, O. [Functional tests of the liver in cardiac patients] Klin, med., Moskva 1928 6: No. 14, 885-90.—Sotgiu, G., & Corazza, G. Osservazioni cliniche e radiologiche sulle alterazioni delle funzioni digestive nei cardiopatici. Arch. ital. mal. app. diger., 1939, 8: 148.__ Stanoy6vitch, L., Volgin, S., & Arundjclovitrh, R. Contribution k l'etude de la fonction hepati'i1'"' --M cmrs des cardiopathies. Rev. med. chir. mal. foie, 1937. 12: 297-307. ---- Disability. See also subheading Forensic aspect. Blair, A. A. Heart disease and work. J. Arkansas M. Soc, 1940-41, 37: 39.—Cattabeni, C. M. Cardiopatie ed invalidity. Arch, antrop. crim., Milano, 1939, 59: 370-81.- Cavagliano. B. Malattie di cuore ed invalidity. Med. lavoro, 1926, 17: 214- 21.—Cazzarolli, G. II valore della prognosi nelle malattie di cuore nei riguardi della invalidity pensionabile. Assist, sociale, Roma, 1939, 13: No. 12, Suppl., 1-47.—D'Zmura, A. P. Non- disabling heart conditions. Pennsylvania M. J., 1940—41, 44: 763.—Notkina, F. Y., & Schattenstein, I. L. [Question of working ability in heart diseases] Sovet. klin., 1932, 17: 217- 22.—Tarsitano, F. L'elettrocardiogramma in assicurazione invalidity. Arch, antrop. crim., Milano, 1939, 59: 395-401.— Van Scoyoc, G. The cardiac patient from the viewpoint of disability. Med. Rec, N. Y., 1940, 151: 19-22.—Venerando, C. Criteri di valutazione dell'invaliditii pensionabile nei cardiopatici. Arch, antrop. crim., Milano, 1939, 59: 382-94.— Weber, A. Estimation of disability for work in cardiac diseases. Sc. Commun. Bain. Inst. Bad Nauheim, 1935, No. 2, 2-8.— White, P. D. The immediate and ultimate prognosis in heart disease; with especial reference to permanent total disability. J. Am. M. Ass., 1939, 112: 2380-4. ---- Electrocardiography. Miske, U. [K. R.] *Das Elektrokardiogramm und das pathologisch-anatomische Herzpraparat. 22p. 8? Berl. [1938] Aechter. A. Untersuchungen mit unipolarer Thoraxablei- tung bei Ventrikelhypertrophie und Schenkelblock. Deut. Arch. klin. Med., 1937, 180: 172-81.—Asher, G. The value of the electrocardiogram in diagnosis (symposium on heart disease) J. Missouri M. Ass., 1940, 37: 197.—Baugh, D. D. The role of the electrocardiograph in suspected heart disease. Mississippi Doctor, 1941-42, 19: 87.—Borisova, E. I., Maliutina, M. I., & Rusinov, V. S. [On the clinical significance of the partial electrocardiography (variability of partial electrocardiogram in certain affections of the heart)] Klin, med., Moskva, 1941, 19: 65-71.—Boros, J. [Electrocardiography in diagnosis and prognosis of heart diseases] Orv. hetil., 1939, 83: 381-6.— Buchem, F. S. P. van, & Polak Daniels, L. [Electrocardio- graphic examinations in acute infections] Ned. tschr. geneesk., 1932, 76: pt 3, 4318, 2 pl. Also Deut. Arch. klin. Med., 1932, 174: 250-67.—Burkhardt. Electrocardiograph changes in diphtheria and scarlet fever. Arch. Pediat., N. Y., 1940, 57: 536—9.—Clerc, A., & Levy, R. Sur certaines anomalies ('dectro- cardiographiques observees au cours des maladies infectieuses aigues. Presse med., 1930, 38: 1257-60.—Drawe, C. E., Hafkesbring, E. M., & Ashman, R. Children's electrocardio- grams; the changes in children's electrocardiograms produced by rheumatic and congenital heart disease. Am. J. Dis. Child., 1937, 53: 1470-84.—Falkiewicz, A. [Effect of high and low diaphragm on the electrocardiogram of a normal and diseased heart] Polskie arch. med. wewn., 1938, 16: 465.—Franke, M., & Lipinski, W. [Electrocardiographic changes in infectious diseases] Polska gaz. lek., 1936, 15: 157-60.—Hall, D. The value of electrocardiography in diagnosis. Postgrad. M. J., Lond., 1936, 12: 116-28—Kisch, F. Zur Beeinflussung des Elektrokardiogramms Herzkranker durch den Carotissinus- druckversuche bei tiefer Inspirationsstellung. Klin. Wschr., 1933, 12: 1136-8—Konar, N. R., Banerji, J. C, & De, M. N. Electrocardiography in the diagnosis of silent heart diseases. Ind. M. Gaz., 1940, 75: 13-6, pl.—McMillan, T. M. The value of the electrocardiograph in the study of heart disease in chil- dren. Atlantic M. J., 1925-26, 29: 755-60.—Milew, A. Elek- trokardiographische Beobachtungen bei einem Herzkranken. Deut. Arch. klin. Med., 1933-34, 176: 706.—Mion, R. J. La dissociation des seuils en electrodiagnostic. Rev. med. fr., 1939, 20: 453.—Mohamed Ibrahim. The electrocardiogram in cardiac disorders. J. Egypt. M. Ass., 1933, 16: 232; 302 — Robert-Levy, J. Les anomalies transitoires des complexes ventriculaires eiectriques au cours des cardiopathies. Prat. med. fr., 1931, 12: 25-33.—Rosa. Nouveaux aspects diagnosti- nues par les ondes longues et courtes dans les maladies de cceur. Bull. Soc eiectroradiol. med. France, 1938, 26: 560-3.— Schmitt, W. Der Elektrokardiograph im vertrauensarztlichen Dienst. Vertrauensarzt, 1938, 6: 1-6.—Shookhoff, C, & Taran, L. M. Electrocardiographic studies in infectious dis- eases; preliminary report. Am. Heart J., 1930-31, 6: 541-7. ------ Electrocardiographic studies in infectious diseases; normal children. Am. J. Dis. Child., 1931, 42: 342-55 — JJnghvary, L., & Obal, F. [The single-phase current of the heart and the point of lesion] Magy. orv. arch., 1940, 41: 480- 9~-Valle Quintavalla, E. Contribuci6n al estudio electro- cardiografico de las enfermedades de la infancia. Rev. chilena pediat., 1941, 12: 184-213. ---- Emergency. See also Heart failure, acute. Brow, G. R. Cardiac emergencies and their treatment. J. Maine M. Ass., 1940, 31: 12-7.—Campbell, J. M. H. Heart attacks. Guy's Hosp. Gaz., Lond., 1929, 43: 358-65.— HEART DISEASE 267 HEART DISEASE Coombs, C. F. Heart attacks. Brit. M. J., 1928, 1: 1009-13.— Cotton, T. F. Cardiac emergencies. Practitioner, Lond., 1930, 124- 289-97—Crawford, P. T. Treatment of cardiac emer- gencies. Memphis M. J., 1941, 16: 73-5.—De Zoysa, V. P. Cardio-vascular emergencies. J. Ceylon Brit. M. Ass., 1939, 36- 115-8—East, T. The modern treatment of heart attacks. Med. Press & Circ, Lond., 1938, 197: 148-51—Ernstene, A. C. Emergency management in the crises of heart disease. Med. Clin. N. America, 1935-36, 19: 1857 -64.—Gosse, A. H. Emer- gencies in cardiac disease. Brompton Hosp. Rep., Lond., 1939, I: 153-8. Also Practitioner, Lond., 1938, 140: 337-43 — Gottlieb, M. L. Fingertip "facts about cardiac emergencies. Med. Rec, N. Y., 1941, 153: 24.—Gutzmann. Schnellbehand- lung akuter Herzstorungen. Fortsch. Med., 1928, 46: 485.— Harrison, T. R. Cardiovascular emergencies. South. M. & S., 1941, 103: 533-5.—Heninger, B. R. Bedside diagnosis and treatment of cardiac emergencies. N. Orleans M. & S. J., 1937- 38, 90: 475-9.—Hoskin. T. J. Cardiac emergencies. Clin. J., Lond., 1937, 66: 279; 327.—Hoyle, C. Cardiac emergencies. Brompton Hosp. Rep., Lond., 1938, 7: 145-64. Also Postgrad. M. J., Lond., 1938, 14: 135; 184.—Kirk, R. C, Baughn, H. A., & Coons, J. J. Acute cardiac emergencies. Ohio M. J., 1938, 34: 633-7.—Lajoie, J. M. Cardiac emergencies. Minnesota M., 1931, 14: 517-20.—Lyon, J. A. The diagnosis and treat- ment of cardiac emergencies. Tr. Am. Ther. Soc. (1939) 1940, 39: 118-21. Also J. Am. M. Ass., 1940, 114: 835-40.—Luten, D. Cardiac emergencies. J. Missouri M. Ass., 1937, 34: 3.— Morgan, A. C. Treatment of acute cardiac tragedies. Ne- braska M. J., 1927, 12: 41-6.—Murphy, M. A. Cardiac emergencies and their treatment. Med. Times, N. Y., 1941, 69: 334-8.—Nathanson, M. H. Treatment of cardiac emergen- cies. Minnesota M., 1935, 18: 455-60.—Pardee, H. E. B. The treatment of certain cardiac emergencies. J. M. Soc. N. Jersey, 1926, 23: 172-7. Also N. York State J. M., 1926, 26: 175-8.—Podolsky, E. Emergency physical measures in heart disease. J. Am. Inst. Homeop., 1940, 33: 241.—Reeves, L. H. Cardiac emergencies. Texas J. M., 1933, 29: 33-7.—Robey, W. H. Recognition and treatment of some acute cardiac accidents. Internat. Clin., 1938, n. ser., 1: 63-71.—Sachs, A. Cardiac emergencies. Nebraska M. J., 1930, 15: 384-91.— Sprague, H. B. Heart attacks. Boston M. & S. J., 1927, 196: 472-6.—Strong, G. F. The treatment of some cardiac emer- gencies. Canad. M. Ass. J., 1939, 41: 586.—White, P. D. The diagnosis and treatment of cardiovascular emergencies, heart attacks. J. Indiana M. Ass., 1940, 33:1-7.—Willus, F. A. Some cardiac emergencies. Med. Clin. N. America, 1938, 22: 895-906. ---- Endocrine aspect. See also under names of endocrine diseases as Goiter; Myxedema; Thyrotoxicosis, &c. Alzona, L. La funzionalita dell'organo insulare nei cardio- patici indagata mediante la curva glicemica capillaro-venosa. Fisiol. & med., Roma, 1933, 4: 763-73.—Binet, L., & Weller, G. La repercussion des etats endocriniens sur le cceur. Bull. Soc. med. hop. Paris, 1935, 3. ser., 51: 1483-5.—Curschmann, H. Die endokrinen Grundlagen der Herzschwache. Med. Welt, 1930, 4: 881-4.—Hutton, J. H. The endocrines in heart dis- ease. Indust. M., 1940, 9: 135-8.—Kabanow, N. Les glandes endocrines chez les cardiaques. Rev. med., Par., 1934, 51: 517-38.—Oumansky, V., & Longuet, A. Le syndrome endo- crino-cardiaque. Presse med., 1938, 46: 388-91.—Zarday, I. [Ovariogenous heart disorders] Orv. hetil., 1938, 82: 856. ---- Etiology. AndrIs, M. S. *Pathogenie des cardiopathies; syphilis et rhumatisme [Geneve] 40p. 8° Morges, 1924. Shipsey, M. B. Original observations and theories on cardiac disease and the normal heart with a note on alcohol. 40p. 16? Birmingham, 1920. Annes Dias. Meteorologia e cardiopathias. Brasil med., 1928, 42: 915-23.—Asher, G. Cardiac impairments to be con- sidered in the so-called normal heart. Kansas City M. J., 1940, 16: No. 7, 18-21.—Bacmeister, A. Die Beeinflussung des Herzens durch Thoraxdeformitaten und Lungenkrankheiten. Nauheim. Fortbild. Lehrg., 1937, 13: 142-56.—Baker, L. A. Analysis of the etiology in 815 cases of organic heart disease. • Med. Bull. Veterans Admin., 1941-42, 18: 254-65.—Beck, C. S. Extrinsic lesions of the heart. Texas J. M., 1940-41, 36: 468- 72. Also Dia med., B. Air., 1941, 13: 680-4.—Bonsdorff, B. von. Less common causes of heart disease. Acta med. scand., 1939, 100: 320-51. Also Nord. med., 1939, 3: 2709-13. Heart disease of unusual or unknown origin. Acta med. scand., 1939, 100: 320-435. ------ Neurogenic heart lesions. Ibid., 352-89.—Brooks, H. The important etiologic factors in cardiac disease. J. M. Soc. N. Jersey, 1927, 24: 417-25.—Bryan, W. E. Non-valvular heart disease. J. Tennessee M. Ass., 1934, 27: 116-24.—Carr, J. G. Trichterbrust and cardiac disease. Mod. Concepts Card. Dis., 1938, 7: No. 2, 1.—Chandler, J. F. Some causes of heart disease other than infections. J. Missouri M. Ass., 1927, 24: 296-8.—Coombs, C. F. The aetiology of cardiac disease. Bristol Med. Chir. J., 1926, 43: 1-19, 2 pl — Cyriax, E. The relation of dorso-cervical postural deficiencies to cardiac disease, especially from middle life onwards. Res Q. Am. Phys. Educ. Ass., 1936, 7: 74-6.—David, A. Quelques remarques concernant les cardiopathies acquises. J. sc med Lille, 1926, 44: pt 2, 286-90—Dedic, S. La cardiopathie cyphotique. Arch. mal. cceur, 1930, 23: 33-6.—Domains, A. von. Ueber Restzustande am Herzen nach Diphtherie und Gelenkrheumatismus, ihre Bedeutung fur die korperliche Leistungsfahigkeit und die Moglichkeit ihrer therapeutischen Beeinflussung. Med. Welt, 1938, 12: 1-7.—Dumas, A. Les syndromes d'instabilite tensionnelle, crises cardiaques et anaphylaxie. J. med. Lyon, 1932, 13: 567-73. ------ Le coeur d'hypotension. Concours med., 1940, 62: 771.—Fenton, C. C. A review of the etiology and pathology of various cardiac conditions. West Virginia M. J„ 1934, 30:539-42.—Frankenau, H. Gibt es ein Lordosenherz? Schweiz. med. Wschr., 1936, 66: 707.—Fuson, L. H. Etiological incidence of organic heart disease. J. Missouri M. Ass., 1932, 39: 128-34.—Gammon, J. E. The etiology of heart disease. South. M. J., 1933, 26: 219-23.— Gonzalez Segura, R., & Lanari, A. El aparato cardiovascular en los slndromes miotonicos. Rev. argent, card., 1940-41, 7: 363-73.—Gonzalo, G. R. Lesiones cardfacas asociadas. Siglo med., 1926, 78: 208.—Halsey, R. H. Etiology of heart disease. J. Am. M. Ass., 1932, 98: 593-8— Heart disease as an accident. Lancet, Lond., 1936, 1: 799.—Helstein, E. M., Rapoport, J. L., & Bogdatian, M. G. [Effect of sodium salicylate on the develop- ment of experimental allergic affections of the heart] Ter. arkh., 1939, 17: No. 2, 16-22.—Katz, G. J. Zur Frage der Aetiologie der Herzkrankheiten. Zschr. klin. Med., 1931, 116: 214; 217; 437.—MacErlean, D. A. The heart in disease. Irish J. M. Sc, 1934, ser. 6, 644-53.—Masugi, M., Sato, Y., & Todo, S. Ueber die Veranderungen des Herzens durch das spezifische Antiherzserum; experimentelle Untersuchungen uber die allergischen Gewebsschaden des Herzens. Tr. Soc path, jap., 1935, 25: 211-6.—Mut, A. Etiologfa general de las cardiopatias. Progr. clin., Madr., 1928, 36: 693-701.— Nuckols, O. P. Etiology in the diagnosis of heart disease. Kentucky M. J., 1932, 30: 179-83.—Pern, S. The origin and treatment of cardiac disease. Med. Rec, N. Y., 1940, 151: 15-9.—Perry, C. B. The aetiology of heart disease. Brit. M. J., 1934, 1: 278-80. Also repr.—Pinchin, A. J. S. The effects on the heart of disease of other systems, and indications in treatment. Postgrad. M. J., Lond., 1933, 9: 173-9.—Pi Sufier, A., & Bellido, J. M. Toxics anabolics i catab61ics del cor. Tr. Soc. biol., Barcel., 1913, 1: 79-82, 4 pl.—Scott, A. Main causes of chronic heart disease. Brit. M. J., 1935, 2: 867.— Stephens, G. A. Some remarks on insect bites as a cause of heart disease. Med. J. & Rec, 1926, 123: 224-8. Also repr.-- Siimegi, J. [Origin of heart diseases and their therapy] Gy6- gyaszat, 1930, 70: 961-3.—Temple, H. C. Has the use of acetylsalicylic acid been a factor in the increase in fatal heart disease? Ohio M. J., 1936, 32: 429.—Weiss, S, Heart and deficiency diseases. In Diagn. Treat. Cardiovasc. Dis. (Stroud, W. D.) Phila., 1940, 2: 1252-93.—White, P. D. Climate, mode of life, and heart disease. Ann. Int. M., 1938-39, 12: 6-12. Also Arch. lat. amer. card., Mex., 1938, 8: 88-98.—Wood, E. E. Some factors in heart-disease. S. Afr. M. J., 1933, 7: 319-23.— Wood, F. L. The heart disease problem; the role of tobacco. Med. World, 1935, 53: 371-5.—Wyckoff, J., & Lingg, C. Etiology in organic heart disease. Am. Heart J., 1925-26, 1: 446-70. ---- Etiology: Exercise. See also Heart function, Variation: Exercise; Heart muscle, Fatigue; Heart neurosis. Geitner, W. *Zwei Falle schwerer Herz- schadigung nach starker korperlicher Anstren- gung [Berlin] 16p. 8? Duderstadt, 1935. Meesmann, K. *Genese, Diagnose und Prog- nose der Herzveranderungen beim Skilauf [Bonn] 31p. 8? Bochum-Langendreer, 1932. Stehr, R. *Elektrokardiographische Unter- suchungen zur Frage des Sportherzens. 25p. 8? Bonn, 1934. Behr, W. Ueber ein eigenartiges Sportlerherz. Zschr. Kreislaufforsch,. 1935, 27: 673-9.—Cooper, E. L., O-Sullivan, J., & Hughes, E. Athletics and the heart: an electrocardio- graphic and radiological study of the response of the healthy and diseased heart to exercise. Med. J. Australia, 1937, 1: 569-79 —Cova, F. Su di un caso di grave lesione cardiaca da sforzo. Italia san., 1910, 6: 196; 219.—Deaver, G. G. Exercise and heart disease. Res. Q. Am. Phys. Educ. Ass., 1939, 10: 24-34 —Deutsch, F. Das Sportherzproblem. Wien. klin. Wschr 1933, 46: 849-55.—Dietlen. Ueber das Sportherz. Vereinsbl. pfalz. Aerzte, 1926, 38: 217; 233.—Nissen, W. Ueber funktionelle Herzstorung bei Kmdern durch korperliche Ueberanstrengung und das Symptom des kranken Herzen beim Kinde. Jahrb. Kinderh., 1935, 3. F., 95: 96-109.—Oille, J. A. Exercise and the heart. Health, Toronto, 1933, 1: No. 3, 8; 14. Etiology: Infection. See also proper names of infections. Anderson, H. B. Treatment of the fever heart. Canada Lancet, 1915, 33: 8-13.—Andreev, K. A. [Diagnosis and treat- ment of the heart functions in certain infectious diseases; on HEART DISEASE 268 HEART DISEASE typhoid and typhus fevers] Voen. med. J., Moskva, 1909, 225: med. spec, pt., 434—47.—Bernheim, S. Influence des maladies infectieuses sur le cceur. C. rend. Congr. internat. med., 1900 Sect. path, gen., 295-300.—Brown, A. G., jr. The heart in acute infectious diseases. Virginia M. Semi-month., 1909-10, 14: 369-72.—Carden, J. J. C6thisme cardia- que des adolescents. 83p. 8? Par., 1937. Bolten, G. C. [Psychoses resulting from heart diseases] Geneesk. gids, 1930, 8: 362-8.—Drewry, P. H.. jr, & Wall, J. H. Mental reactions and their management in patients with cardiac disease. Am. J. Psychiat., 1937-38, 94: 561-76.—Francais, H., & Darcanne, G. Sur les psychoses d'origine cardiaque. C. rend. Congr. aU6n. neur. France (1907) 1908, 17. Congr., 93-8.—Gibson, A. G. Mental changes in cardiac disease. J. Ment. Sc, Lond., 1931, 76: 632-40.—Gordon, A. H., & Cohen, W. The mental complications of heart disease. Canad. M. Ass. J., 1938, 39: 517-22.—Matsuoka, R. Ueber die paychi- schen Storungen bei den Herzkrankheiten. Mitt. Med. Akad. Kioto, 1934, 11: 308.—Riimke, H. C. [On psychoses in diseases of the heart] Ned. tschr. geneesk., 1939, 83: 728-35.—Spiel- mever, W. Kreislaufstorungen und Psychosen. Zschr. ges. Neur. Psychiat., 1929-30, 123: 536-73.—Urechia, C. I. A propos de la psychose cardiaque. Arch, internat. neur., Par., 1932, 51: 473-85.—Wortis, J. Cardiac psychosis and the symp- tom of anxiety. Am. Heart J., 1937, 13: 394-412. ---- Manifestation: Palpitation. Asson, M. Osservazioni intorno le awertenze cliniche del dott. M. S. Levi e rettificazione di due tra' casi pratici riferit nelle medesime. Mem. med. contemp., Venez., 1846, 15: SOS- SI.—Baker, D. M. Palpitation. Lancet, Lond., 1936, 2: 787- 9.—Blum, W. Ueber das Herzklopfen und seine Behandlung, Praxis, Bern, 1937, 26: 297-8.—Cavaliero, G. Caso di pronta guarigione di una degenerata cronica febbre periodica con palpitazione del cuor mediante l'effetto della digitale porpurea. Filiatre sebezio, Nap., 1840, 20: 75-80.—Gilchrist, R. Palpita- tion and tachycardia. Practitioner, Lond., 1941, 146: 227- 32.—Giraud-Costa, E. Essai sur la valeur psychologique des palpitations. Rev. med. fr., 1932, 13: 363.—Hilton, R. Palpi- tation. Practitioner, Lond., 1937, 139: 592-6.—Kraines, S. H. Palpitation. In his Ther. Neuroses, Phila., 1941, 293 — Levi, M. G. Awertenze cUniche sul cardiopalmo. Mem. med. contemp., Venez., 1846, 15: 65-112.—Marchal, G. Traite- ment des palpitations, et des extrasystoles. In Ther. med. (Loeper, M.) Par., 1933, 6: 213-26.—Paroxysmal palpitation; some clinical varieties and their treatment. Bull. Lederle Lab., 1934, 2: 15-22.—Schellong, F. Versuch einer Differential- diagnose und Differentialtherapie des Herzklopfens. Deut. med. Wschr., 1937, 63: 421; 510.—Spada, G. Storia di un palpito di cuore. FiUatre sebezio. Nap., 1835, 9: 17-21.— Veiel, E. Ueber die Behandlung des Herzklopfens. Fortsch. Ther., 1930, 6: 644-6. ---- Manifestation, respiratory. See subheading Respiratory system. Manual. See also under Cardiology. American Heart Association. Diseases of the heart; a summary for layman and lecturer. 35p. 12? N. Y. [1940] Clarke, R. M. Diseases of the heart. 64p. 8? Mountain View, Calif., 1934. Fahrenkamp, K. Der Herzkranke. 287p. 8? Stuttg., 1931. Frey, J. Diseases of the heart. 279p. 22cm. X. Y. [1939] Geraudel, E. Le mecanisme du coeur et ses anomalies; etudes anatomiques et electrocardio- graphiques. 285p. 8? Par., 1928. Also Am. transl. 266p. 8? Bait., 1930. Laxgley, R. W. Your heart and you. 59p. 8? Los Ang. [1928] Leaman, W. G. Management of the cardiac patient. 705p. 23y2cm. Phila. [1940] Lewis, T. Diseases of the heart. 2. ed. 297p. 8? Lond., 1937. Lutembacher, R. Les lesions organiques du cceur; etude clinique, anatomique et therapeuti- que. 350p. fol. Par., 1936. Pardee, H. E. B. What you should know about heart disease. 120p. 12? Phila., 1928. Also 2. ed. 127p. 8? Phila. [1935] Siebeck, R. Die Beurteilung und Behand- lung Herzkranker. 322p. 8? Munch., 1935. HEART DISEASE 273 HEART DISEASE Smith, S. C. That heart of yours. 212p. 8? Phila. [1934] Uhlenbruck, P. Die Herzkrankheiten. 2. Aufl. 422p. 28cm. Lpz., 1939. White, P. D. Heart disease in general prac- tice. 388p. 8? N. Y., 1937. ---- Metabolism. Hose, A. *Beitrag zur Klarung der Frage der Grundumsatzsteigerung bei Herzerkran- kungen. lip. 21cm. Giessen, 1937. Kreiss, H. ^Untersuchungen zur Frage unvollstandiger Oxydationen bei Herzkranken [Wurzburg] 13p. 8? Bottrop, 1933. Suberbielle, H. R. C. A. Contribution a l'6tude de la lactacidemie chez les cardiaques. 52p. 25cm. Bord., 1933. Vogt, W. *Ueber Fliissigkeitsverschiebungen beim Herzkranken [Wurzburg] 7p. 8? Wertheim, 1936. Adlercreutz, E. Urobilinurie nach Flussigkeitszufuhr und Korperbewegung bei kompensierten Herzfehlern. Acta med. scand., 1931, 76: 551-86.—Audo-Gianotti, G. B. Ricerche suU'equilibrio acido-basico nei sangue dei cardiaci compensati, nella fatica. Morgagni, 1931, 73: 1904-12.—Benacchio, L. I gas del sangue (Oj e CO2) nei cardiopatici. Arch. stud. fisiopat. ricambio, 1937, 5: 291-304.—Berland, A., & Donskowa, T. Metabolisme basal et action dynamique specifique chez les cardiaques et les hyperthyroidiens. Arch. mal. coeur, 1934, 27: 510-6.—Biddau, I. Glicemia e curva glicemica nei bambini cardiopatici. Clin, pediat., Mod., 1938, 20: 301-25.—Brodo- vich, L. A. [Lactic acid in the blood in heart diseases] Ter. arkh., 1935, i3: 113-22.—Casanova, F. II consumo periferico del glucosio nei cardiopatici. Cuore & circol., 1934, 18: 2-16.— Ceccarelli, D. Indagini sul tasso colesterinemico nelle cardio- patie. Ibid., 177-94.—Di Monte, R. Contributo alio studio del metabolismo degli idrati di carbonio nei cardiopatici. Clin. med. ital., 1934, 65: 1062-7.—Emmer, V. [Total con- sumption of oxygen during and after work by cardiac patients] Cas. lek. desk., 1935, 74: 785-9.—Gavrila, I., & Caba, E. [Gluco-regulative disorders in cases of cardiac diseases] Spitalul, 1928, 48: 270-3.—Giordano, C, & Griva, L. Ricerche sulla lattacidemia nei cardiopatici e sull'influenza relativa della stasi venosa. Gior. Accad. med. Torino, 1934, 97: 242-6.—Goldberg, J. Sur la teneur du sang en sucre dans les affections cardiaques. Arch. mal. cceur, 1927, 20: 38-40.—Gross, D. Labilidad coloidal de los cardfacos. Rev. med. aliment., Santiago, 1937- 39, 3: 27-32— Harris, I., Jones, E. W., & Aldred, C. N. Blood Ph and lactic acid in different types of heart disease. Q. J. Med., Lond., 1935, 4: 407-15.—Herbst, R. Der Gasstoff- wechsel als Masz der korperlichen Leistungsfahigkeit; Unter- suchungen an Herzkranken. Deut. Arch. klin. Med., 1928, 162: 257-79.—Jervell, O. [Estimation of basal metabolism in heart diseases] Norsk mag. laegevid., 1929, 90: 1269-78 — La Franca, S. Afeccoes cardiacas e vasculares e taxa glicemica. Resenha clin. cient., S. Paulo, 1941, 10: 131-4—Larizza, P. Le varie frazioni di zolfo ematico, plasmatico globulare nelle malattie di cuore. Gior. cUn. med., 1935, 16: 948-58.—L&szlo, D. Stoffwechseluntersuchungen bei Herzkranken. Klin. Wschr., 1928, 7: 1411-4. Also Verh. Deut. Ges. inn. Med., 1928, 40. Kongr., 134-7.—Lucherini, T., & Bufano, M. La glicemia nelle cardiopatie scompensate e compensate. Cuore & circol., 1926, 10: 133-51.—Lukova, A. I. [Clinical observa- tions on alkali reserve in diseases of the heart] Klin. J. Saratov., 1929, 8: 245-53.—Manca, S. Cloruremia e azotemia nelle cardiopatie. Arch. farm, sper., Roma, 1930-31, 51: 81-94.— Mauriac, P., Servante, L., & Broustet, P. La lactacidemie chez les cardiaques. Gaz. hop., 1935, 108: 1683-90.—Meldolesi, G., & Pons, M. La riserva alcalina nelle cardiopatie. Bull. Accad. med. Roma, 1931, 57: 53-6.—Menendez Mercado, J. Con- tribuci6n al estudio del metabolismo basal en las enfermedades del coraz6n. Progr. clin., Madr., 1931, 39: 24; 125.—Menzel. Zur Tagesrhythmik des Wasserhaushaltes bei Gesunden und Herzkranken. Zbl. inn. Med., 1938, 59: 529.—Messina, R. Ricerche sul ricambio intermedio. Fol. med., Nap., 1935, 31: 227-38. ------ Ricerche sulla creatininemia totale nei cardiopatici. Clin. med. ital., 1936, 67: 324-31.—Migliore, M. II glutatione nei sangue dei cardiopatici. Gazz. internaz. med. chir., 1931, 39: 809-12.—Peserico, E. II debito di ossigeno nella valutazione dell'attitudine dei cardiopazienti alia fatica muscolare. Cuore & circol., 1933, 17: 465-501.—Poindexter, C. A., & Bruger, M. Cholesterol content of the blood in heart disease. Arch. Int. M., 1938, 61: 714-9.—Pojer, J. [Glyco- genic disorders in heart diseases] Vest. desk, fysiat., 1938, 18: 194-9.—Romano, S. La glicemia e la curva glicemica nei diversi periodi delle cardiopatie, con e senza insulina. Poli- clinico, 1934, 41: sez. prat., 1841-4.—Rosenthal, F. Herz- schwache als Stoffwechselproblem. Med. Klin., Berl., 1930, 26: 1357-9.—Serra, V., & Nunberg, M. Le modificazioni dello zolfo sanguigno nelle malattie del cuore. Cuore & circol., 1934, 18: 153-66.—Shapiro, S. The basal metabolic rate in cases of chronic cardiac disease and in cases of hypertension. Arch. Int. M., 1926, 38: 385-90.—Siebeck. Trastornos del balance 227475—VOL. 7, 4th series----18 de agua en los cardfacos. Dfa med., B. Air., 1930-31, 3: 193.— Sribner, J., & Brown, M. [Cardiac diseases influencing the quantity of sugar in blood] Vrach. gaz., 1928, 32: 326-8 — Stanojevic, L., & Arandjelovic, R. R. Ueber die Bilirubinamie nach Wasserbelastung bei nicht dekompensierten Herzkranken. Klin. Wschr., 1937, 16: 1386.—Stefanutti, P. Contributo alia conoscenza del ricambio della vitamina C nei cardiopatici e dell'azione diuretica dell'acido ascorbico. Clin. med. ital., 1937 68: 747-59.—Stewart, H. J., & Jack, N. B. The basal metabolic rate in organic heart disease. Am. Heart J., 1940, 19: 738-48.— Tamburri, T. II quadro lipemico nei cardiopatici. Clin. med. ital., 1933, 64: 959-71.—Taterka, H., & Oestreicher, F. Zuckerstoffwechsel und Wasserhaushalt; Insulin und Zucker- belastung bei kardialer Stauung. Klin. Wschr., 1929, 8: 1401.— Tinelli, G. La lattacidemia nei cardiopatici sottoposti a carico di glucosio. Gior. clin. med., 1936, 17: 1315-25.—Torday, A. [Blood sugar in heart diseases] Orv. hetil., 1932, 76: 142.— Troitsky, N. S., & Vilkovyssky, A. L. [On basal metabolism in diseases of the heart] Klin, med., Moskva, 1928, 6: 1237-42.— Uhlenbruck & Merbeck, A. Ueber den Grundumsatz bei Herzkranken. Zschr. klin. Med., 1930, 114: 259-62.—Zak, E. Die Stellung der Leber im Wasserwechsel der Herzkranken. In Bain. & Balneother. Karlsbad (1930) 1931, 12: 283-92. Also Zschr. arztl. Fortbild., 1932, 29: 165-8. ------Feher, G., & Neurath, O. Paradoxes Verhalten des Korpergewichtes gewisser Herzkranker durch negative Perspiratio insensibilis. Zschr. klin. Med., 1934, 127: 201-15.—Zakharova, E. V. [Contents of calcium and potassium in the blood in diseases of the heart] Klin. J. Saratov., 1929, 8: 255-8. ---- Military and naval aspects. Arenberg, H. Heart disease among seamen. Pub. Health Rep., Wash., 1934, 49: 912-20. Also Am. Heart J., 1937, 13: 197-201.—Bocalandro, C. A., Carron, R. F., & Segura, A. S. Cardiopatfas despistadas en la selecci6n del soldado argentino. Rev. san. mil., B. Air., 1941, 40: 389-95.—Gager, L. T. The cardiac disorders of war veterans. U. S. Veterans Bur. M. Bull., 1928, 4: 1-5.—Hartleben. Die Beurteilung zweifelhafter Herzbefunde (Beschleunigungen, Arhythmien, Gerausche) bei den Freiwilligenuntersuchungen hinsichtlich ihrer Bewertung fur die Tauglichkeit. Veroff. Heer. San., 1934, H. 92, 41-84. Sintomas de interpretaci6n dudosa en el coraz6n de los voluntarios. Rev. san. mil., Lima, 1937, 10: 98-143. & Barbieri, P. Sintomas de interpretation dudosa en el coraz6n de los voluntarios. Rev. san. mil., B. Air., 1936, 35: 785; 962.—Heart disease among seamen. U. S. Nav. M. Bull., 1935, 33: 537.—-Hedley, O. F. Observations on heart disease in marine hospital practice. Pub. Health Rep., Wash., 1933, 48: 565-75.—Holmdahl, D. E. [Diagnosis of functional heart disease from the medico-military standpoint] Tskr. mil. halsov., 1926, 51: 1-18.—Kilgore, E. S. The heart in military service. J. Am. M. Ass., 1941, 117: 258-60.—Macllwaine, J. E. A clinical study of some functional disorders of the heart which occur in soldiers. Tr. Ulster M. Soc, 1917-18, 68-96.— Matz, P. B. Statistical studies bearing on problems in the classification of heart disease; heart disease among ex-service men. Am. Heart J., 1928-29, 4: 313; 455.-----■ Heart dis- ease in ex-members of the military forces: a survey of 611 autopsies. Med. Bull. Veterans Admin., 1934-35, 11: 288-94. A study of heart disease among veterans; clinical classification of 500 cases. N. England J. M., 1935, 212: 868- 74.------Analysis of a group of cases as to age at onset and duration of heart disability. Ibid., 929-32.------ An analysis of the more frequent types of anatomic heart disease. Ibid., 1042-8.—Moon, R. O. Affections of tbe heart in time of war. Practitioner, Lond., 1940, 144: 61-5.—Moses, H. M. The cardiac cripple of pre-army age. Mil. Surgeon, 1929, 44: 231-40.—Nesbitt, R. W. Some remarks on the heart in health and disease. J. R. Nav. M. Serv., 1936, 22: 187-200.—Rosin, H. Ueber Herzerkrankungen bei Feldzugsteilnehmern. In Behandl. Kriegsverletz., Jena, 1916, T. 2, 121-33.—Schnizer, von. Zusammenhang zwischen Dienstbeschadigung und Herz- leiden abgelehnt. Med. Klin., BerL, 1926, 22: 1380. ------ Dienstbeschadigung als Ursache fur Herzleiden nicht anerkannt. Ibid., 1575. ------ Dienstbeschadigung fiir ein Herzleiden abgelehnt. Ibid., 1928, 24: 1484-6. —----■ Dienstbeschadi- gung fiir ein Herzleiden angenommen. Ibid., 1930, 26: 320.— White, P. D. The soldier and his heart. War Med., Chic, 1941 1: 158-67. ---- Morbidity. Chiaverini, R. *Contribuigao ao estudo da etiologia das cardiopatias em Sao Paulo. 117p. 23cm. S. Paulo [1939] Aetiology of heart disease in India. J. Ind. M. Ass., 1940-41, 10: 390.—Albert, H. The increase in heart disease; partial explanation in increased proportion of population injured by certain infectious diseases; preUminary note. J. Am. M. Ass., 1927, 88: 2021.—Benjamin, J. E. The heart disease situation in Cincinnati. Am. Heart J., 1926-27, 2: 637-48.—Blaze, J. R. Heart disease in Ceylon. J. Ceylon Brit. M. Ass., 1937, 34: 163-8.—Bolduan, C. F., & Bolduan, N. W. Is the appaUing increase in heart disease real? J. Prevent. M., 1932, 6: 321- 33.—Cahan, J. M. The incidence of heart disease in school children. J. Am. M. Ass., 1929, 92: 1576-9— Castronuovo, G. Cardiopatie organiche e funzionaU nei paesi caldi. Gior. ital. med. esot., 1937, 10: 189.—Chiaverini, R. Tipos etiol6gicos de cardiopatia em S. Paulo. Rev. cUn. S. Paulo, 1941, 9: 164-7.— HEART DISEASE 274 HEART DISEASE Clawson, J. Incidence of types of heart disease among 30,265 autopsies, with special reference to age and sex. Am. Heart J., 1941, 22: 607-24— Coffen, T. H. The incidence of heart disease in the Pacific Northwest. Ibid., 1929-30, 5: 99-103.— Cohn, A. E. An analysis of the apparent increase in the heart diseases. J. Am. M. Ass., 1935, 105: 1394.—Cole, L. R. Cardiac disease among 28,139 newly entering students at the University of Wisconsin. Am. J. M. Sc, 1941, 201: 197-202 — Condry, R. J. Heart disease in West Virginia. West Virginia M. J., 1932, 28: 485.—Couto. Herzerkrankungcn nach tropi- schen Infektionskrankheiten. Deut. med. Wschr., 1926, 52: 554.—Davison, H. M., & Thoroughman, J. C. A study of heart disease in the Negro race. South. M. J., 1928, 21: 464-9.—DePorte, J. V. Heart disease in the State of New York, a statistical review of mortaUty and morbidity. Am. Heart J., 1929-30, 5: 652-9. ------ Heart disease in general medical practice; preliminary report of morbidity survey con- ducted by the New York State Department of Health. Ibid., 1933, 8: 476-89.—Dublin, L. I. L'accroissement des maladies de cceur aux Etats-Unis. Presse med., 1934, 42: 13.—Durbin, E. Heart disease in Colorado. Rocky Mountain M. J., 1939, 36: 173-80.—Emerson, H. Incidence and prevalence of dis- eases of the heart. J. Indiana M. Ass., 1938, 31: 433-7.— Farmer, H. E. The incidence of heart disease among Negroes. J. Nat. M. Ass., N. Y., 1940, 32:198-203.—Fischer, O. Schiidi- gungen und Erkrankungen des Herzens in den Tropen und ihre Behandlung. Tungchi med. Mschr., 1932-33, 8: 222-30.— Flaxman, N. Heart disease in the Middle West (incidence and etiology of 1,646 cases at the Cook County hospital) Am. J. M. Sc, 1934, 188: 639-46.—Gager, L. T., & Dunn, W. L. Heart disease in Washington, D. C.; a study of etiologic types and the factors of race, age and sex in 1,200 cases. Med. Ann. District of Columbia, 1933, 2: 112-7.—Geiger, J. C. The problem of heart disease in the city and county of San Francisco. Bull. South. Pacific Gen. Hosp., 1932, 1: 69-74. ------Sampson, J. J. [et al.] A survey of heart disease mor- bidity in San Francisco. Am. Heart J., 1936, 12: 137-52.— Gonz&lez Sabathi£, L., & Vidal, C. Las cardiopatias en trcs mil autopsias. Actas Congr. nac. med., Rosario, 1934, 5: gt 4, 704-7. Also In Temas cardiol. (Gonzalez Sabathie, L.) i. Air., 1935, 1: 265-70.—Goodman, M., & Prescott. J. W. Heart disease among adolescent school children of New York City. J. Am. M. Ass., 1934, 103: 157-61.—Grady, C. R. Heart disease in the Negro based on a study of 100 cases. Tr. M. Soc. Virginia, 1916, 46: 56-61.—Gupta, J. D. Heart affections in BengaU babies. Ind. M. Gaz., 1931, 66: 124-6.— Haraszti Bernolak, B. [Diseases of the heart among school- children] Nepegeszsegugy, 1941,22: 374-80.—Harrison, F. F. Heart disease in a rural community. Proc. Conf. Rural M. (1938) 1939, 64-70 [Discussion] 81-94.—Heart disease in Ceylon. J. Ceylon Brit. M. Ass., 1937, 34: 217.—Heimann, H. L., Strachan, A. S., & Heyman, S. C. Cardiac disease among South African non-Europeans (preliminary note) Brit. M. J., 1929, 1: 344-6.—Holand, H. Where is heart disease increasing? Crusader, 1941, 33: No. 2, 5; 16.—Hughes, T. A., & Yufcuf, M. Further observations on heart disease in' the Punjab. Ind. M. Gaz., 1931, 66: 423-5.—Jones, T. D., & White, P. D. Heart disease and disorders in New England. Tr. Ass. Am. Physicians, 1926, 41: 7-15.—Karcher, J. F. Etiological types of heart disease in Canton. Chin. M. J., 1936, 50: 705-15.—Laws, C. L. The etiology of heart disease in whites and Negroes in Tennessee. Am. Heart J., 1933, 8: 608-15.—Macera, J. M., & Ruchelli, A. P. Datos estadfsticos sobre la frecuencia de cardiopatias en la infancia. Sem. med., B. Air., 1940, 47: pt 2, 139. ------& Gaig, R. Frecuencia de cardiopatias en 10,000 escolares de la capital federal; estudio clfnico, electrocardiogrifico, telerradiogriifico, fonocardiografico y de orientaci6n profesional. Ibid., 255-7.—Maher, C. C, Sittler, W. W., & Elliott, R. A. Heart disease in the Chicago area; a study of the etiologic factors in 1,000 cases. J. Am. M. Ass., 1935, 105: 263-8.—Moore, A. G. The incidence of cardiac diseases in 297 cases. J. Indiana M. Ass., 1935, 28: 419-22 Also Dallas M. J., 1937, 23: 68-71.—Norgaard, A. Disabling heart lesions amongst the working classes in Denmark in 1931. Acta med. scand., 1932, 78: 427-46.—Rathe, H. W., & Paul, W. D. A study of the incidence of the various etiologic types of heart disease in Iowa (a review of 1,329 cases) J. Iowa M Soc, 1933, 23: 125-31.—Rauh, L. W. The incidence of or- ganic heart disease in school children. Am. Heart J., 1939, 18: 705-14. ——— The incidence of organic heart disease in the school chUdren of Cincinnati. J. Med., Cincin., 1939-40, 20: 30-2.-—Richter, I. M. Incidence and variety of heart disease in school children of San Francisco; 2 years' survey. J Am M. Ass., 1931, 97: 1000-2. Also repr.—Robertson, G. H. Heart disease in general practice in New Zealand. N. Zealand M. J., 1936, 35: 146-53.—Routier, D. Cardiopathies en milieu scolaire parisien. Paris med., 1939, 111: 396-400.—Sampson, J. J., Christie, A.. Geiger, & J. C. Incidence and type of heart disease in San Francisco school chUdren. Am. Heart J. 1938 15: 661-70. Also repr.—Schwab, E. H., & Schuize,' V. e! The incidence of heart disease and of the etiological types in a southern dispensary. Ibid., 1931-32, 7: 223-34.------ Heart disease in the American Negro of the South. Ibid., 1931-32, 7: 710-7—Valdes Lambea, J. Las enfermedades del coraz6n y de los vasos en el Rif. Progr. clin., Madr., 1916 8: 306-17, 8 pl.—Viko, L. E. Heart disease in the Rocky Mountain region. Am. Heart J., 1930-31, 6: 264-73.— White, P. D. The incidence of heart disease in Massachusetts Boston M. & S. J., 1927, 196: 689-93. ------& Jones, T. d! Heart disease and disorders in New England. Am. Heart J.i 1927-28, 3: 302-18.—Williams, A. W. Heart disease in the native population of Ucanda; bacterial infections of the heart. Last Afr. M. J., i'.i:ss 30. 15: 279, pl.; 1939,-40 16: 2.— W'inans, H. M., & Dunslnn. K. M. Heart disease in North Texas. Texas J. M., I'.i35 36, 31: 444-7.—Wood, J. E., jr, Jones, T. D., & Kimbrough, R. D. The etiology of heart dis- ease; a clinical studv <>f 623 cases with certain observations on race and cUmate. Am. .1. M. Sc, 1926, 172: 185-94. Mortality. Hedley, O. F. Studies of heart disease mortality; an analysis of the accuracy of deaths recorded as being due to heart disease in Wash- ington, D. C, during 1932, with a discussion of the defects of the present method of tabulating deaths, and suggestions for a new system based upon etiological factors. 49p. 8? Wash., 1936. Schwarzmuller, H. *Bemerkenswerte Falle von plotzhchem Herztod bei korperlicher An- strengung [Munchen] 40p. 2234cm. Speyer 1937. Albert, H. Increasing mortality from heart disease; sugges- tions as to probable reasons. J. Am. M. Ass., 1927, 89: 1312- 5.—Awdejew, M. I., Wainberg, S. B. [et al.] Die Histopatholo- gie des extramuralen Herznervensystems bei plotzlichem (Herz-) Tode. Virchows Arch., 1934, 293: 351-64.—Beitzke, H. Tod und Herz. Erg. ges. Med., 1930, 14: 329-63.— Benjamin, J. E. Why the increase in the death rate in heart disease in the fifth and sixth decades of life. J. Med., Cincin 1932, 13: 71-84.—Brandis, W. Plotzlicher Herztod, UnfaU- folge? Med. Klin., Berl., 1931, 27: 214.—Change in the age distribution of deaths from heart disease. Pub. Health Rep Wash., 1929, 44: 1889.—Cleland, J. B. Mortality from heart disease as revealed by post mortem statistics. Med. J. Aus- tralia, 1930, 1: 579-81.—Cossio, P. La mortalidad por en- fermedades del coraz6n en el pais. Bol. san., B. Air., 1937, 1: 436-43.—Costedoat, A. L. D. La mort subite au cours des affections du cceur et de l'aorte. Arch. med. pharm. mil 1929, 91: 89-112.—Dauer, C. C. MortaUty rates of organic diseases of the heart by geographical areas in the United States. Am. Heart J., 1934-35, 10: 955-64.—Edmonds, T. J. Heart disease versus tuberculosis; a study of mortaUty statistics J. Iowa M. Soc, 1926, 16: 308.—Fisher, J. W. Further mor- taUty data of non-organic systolic heart murmurs. Abstr. Proc Ass. Life Insur. M. Dir. America, 1934, 20: 160-3.— Flanm, E., & Nagl, F. Sekundenherztod ohne Kammerflim- mern. Deut. Arch. klin. Med., 1937, 180: 296-307.—Gehman, J. M. Heart disease lead the death parade. Health Cult., N. Y., 1941, 47: No. 11, 12.—Gelbfisz, A. [Sudden death due to diseases of the heart] Warsz. czas. lek., 1936, 13: 88; 117.— Goldberg, F. Ueber den plotzlichen Herztod bei Kranz- adererkrankung. Wien. klin. Rdsch., 1916, 30: 43; 55; 70; 81.—Gonzalez Lizcano, J. Muerte subita por inhibici6n cardiaca. Arch, med., Madr., 1928, 29: 595-7.—Halsey, R. H. Observations on the mortality of heart disease in New York State. Am. Heart J., 1928-29, 4: 94-102.—Hanser. Ueber drei interessante Herztodesfalle. Vereinsbl. pfalz. Aerzte, 1928, 40: 228-32.—Heart disease kills 500,000 Americans annually. Good Health, 1940, 75: 115.—Heart disease likely fate of young men in big cities. Science News Lett., 1937, 32: No. 847, 10.—Hedley, O. F. A critical analysis of heart disease mortaUty. J. Am. M. Ass., 1935, 105: 1405-11. ------ A stl'^y of 450 fatal cases of heart disease occurring in Washing- ton (D. C.) hospitals during 1932, with special reference to etiology, race and sex. Pub. Health Rep., Wash., 1935, 50: 1127-53 ------ The picture of heart disease mortality °£&lned. .from Vltal statistics in Washington, D. C. during 1932. Ibid 1936, 51:285-98. ------ Trends, geographical and racial distribution of mortaUty from heart disease among persons 5-24 years of age in the United States during recent years (1922-36); a preliminary report. Ibid., 1939, 54: 2271- 9/—He«nman-Hatry, W- Herztod und Unfall. Med. KUn., Berl., 1928, 24: 1596.—Hertzog, L. S. Why so many die of heart ailments. J. Am. Inst. Homeop., 1940, 33: 338-44.— Hoesslin, H. von. Der Herztod; nach elektrokardiographi- schen Aufnahmen. Erg. inn. Med. Kinderh., 1931, 39: 276- Too'i ZT~^7n Per Herztod des Menschen. Med. KUn., Berl., 1931, 27: 573-6. Also Verh. Berl. med. Ges. (1931) 1932, 62: leil 2, 29-39— Jaffe, R. Was Uegt pathologisch-anatomisch und pathologisch-physiologisch dem Exitus subitus durch sogenannten Herzschlag zugrunde? Zschr. iirztl. FortbUd., 1931, 28: 664.—Jeckeln, E. Die chronischen Erkrankungen im Gebiet des Lungenkreislaufs als die Ursache eines plotz- hchen Herztodes. Med. KUn., Berl., 1941, 37: 209-12.— jrtz' Fr:.^1' In many a heart case death begins at 40. Cru- sader, 1941, 33: No. 2, 13-6— Lafont-Gouzi. Observation de mort naturelle, par cessation progressive des fonctions du coeur. J. med. Toulouse, 1865, 4. ser., 4: 329-31.—Laplace, u. a. the likelihood of sudden unexpected death in heart disease. Internat. Clin., 1939, n. ser., 1: 180-92, 3 pl — LeRoy, G. V., & Snider, S. S. The sudden death of patients with few symptoms of heart disease. J. Am. M Ass 1941, 117: 2019-24— Lisa, J. R. Pathologic findings in the heart in sudden cardiac deaths. Ann. Int. M., 1938-39, 12: 1968-82. Also repr.—McClure, W. T. Sudden heart death. West HEART DISEASE 275 HEART DISEASE Virginia M. J., 1933, 29: 157-60.—McKinnon, N. E. Heart disease mortality; the public health problem in Ontario. Canad. Pub. Health J., 1939, 30: 288-93.—Martini, P., & Sckell J Das Sterben des menschlichen Herzens. Deut. Arch 'klin. Med., 1927-28, 158: 350-80.—Morgan, P. W. Sudden heart death. J. Kansas M. Soc, 1941, 42: 285-9.— Mortality from heart disease. J. Am. M. Ass., 1937, 108: 120 —Muerte (La) subita en los cardlacos. Rev. med. con- temp., Madr., 1909, 31: 289.—Nagl, F. Elektrokardiogra- phische Beobachtungen bei Sekundenherztod. Mitt. Ges. inn. Med. Wien, 1935, 34: 1-5.—Ortiz y Ramirez, T. La muerte repentina y los cardlacos. Rev. As. med. mex., 1927, 6: 76-8.—Penati, F. Reperto elettrocardiografico in un caso di morte cardiaca improvvisa. Gior. Accad. med. Torino, 1933, 96: pt 2, 26-31.—Probability (The) of dying from organic heart disease. Statist. Bull. Metrop. Life Insur., 1933, 14: 5.— Reuter, F. Ueber den plotzlichen Herztod und dessen Nach- weis an der Leiche. Wien. klin. Wschr., 1926, 39: 1086-92 — Revell, S. T. R. Is the death rate from heart disease increas- ing? J. M. Ass. Georgia, 1938, 27: 309-12.—Rosselli Del Turco, L. L'influenza dei fattori meterologici sopra la mor- tality per malattie di cuore. Riv. clin. med., 1936, 37: 498; 555.—Schnizer. von. Zusammenhang zwischen Tod infolge Herzschwache und Dienstbeschadigung durch Verwundung angenommen. Fortsch. Med., 1926, 44: 787. ------ Tod an Lungenentzundung bei Herzleiden nicht als mittelbare Dienstbeschadigungsfolge anerkannt. Med. Klin., Berl., 1926,22:966.—Singer, L. Ueber akute Herztodfalle im fruhe- sten Kindesalter. Zschr. Kinderh., 1932, 53: 660-5.—Sinna- durai, N. Heart disease as a cause of sudden death. J. Ceylon Brit M. Ass., 1938, 35: 174-7.—Stepp, W. Herzkrankheiten und Herztod. Med. Welt, 1933, 7: 1017; 1092.—Stone, C. T. The mortality from heart disease: a challenge. J. Am. M. Ass., 1934, 103: 151-4.—Tesar, J. [Two cases of sudden death due to heart disease] Cas. lek. cesk., 1939, 78: 756-60.— Trends in mortality from heart disease among young persons. J. Am. M. Ass., 1940, 114: 1363.—Weber, A. Ueber den plotzlichen Herztod. Klin. Wschr., 1927, 6: 2457-60.— Welz. Plotzlicher Kreislauftod bei enzephalitisartigen Hirn- befunden. Verh. Deut. Ges. Kreislaufforsch., 1937, 10: 258-62.—Willius, F. A. The mode of death in various types of heart disease. Am. J. M. Sc, 1926, 171: 480-5.—Wright, W. Mortality and morbidity from heart disease under industrial and group insurance. Am. Heart J., 1928-29, 4: 448-54. --- Nervous system. Bodechtel, G. Gehirnveranderungen bei Herzkrankheiten. p.657-709. 8? Erlangen, 1932. Also Zschr. ges. Neur. Psychiat., 1932, 140: Elias, S. *Contribution k l'etude des hemi- plegies transitoires des cardiaques. 66p. 8? Par., 1936. Kloz, J. M. V. *Les accidents cerebraux transitoires chez les cardiaques. 55p. 25cm. Bord., 1938. Meurisse, J. Contribution k l'etude des hemiplegies gauches par embolies au cours des cardiopathies. 40p. 8? Par., 1926. Thum, L. *Gehirnveranderungen bei Herz- krankheiten. 44p. 8? Erlangen, 1935. Audier. Les paralysies des cardiaques. In Actual, med. chir. (Fac. med. Marseille) 1939, 4. ser., 35-62.—Avdeev, M. L, Weinberg, S. B. [et al.] [Histopathology of the ex- tramural nervous system of the heart in sudden death] Tr. Moskov. gosud. med. inst., 1935, No. 3, 37-53.—Borruso. G. Ricerche sulla cronassia dei muscoli e nervi periferici nei cardiopazienti. Policlinico, 1934, 41: sez. med., 96-116.— Calabresi, M. Sulla patogenesi delle crisi epilettiche nelle malattie del cuore. Pensiero med., 1931, 20: 363-6 —Chavany, J. A. L'hemipiegie des cardiaques. Presse med., 1936, 44: 587-9.—Felberbaum, D., & Finesilver, B. Cerebral mani- festations in cardiac disorders. Med. J. & Rec, 1929, 129: 247-50.—Fetterman, J. L., & Ashe, W. F. Cerebral debut of certain cases of cardiac diseases. Ohio M. J., 1938, 34: 1354-8.— Gonzalo, G. R. Fen6menos nerviosos de algunas cardiopatias. Siglo med., 1928, 81: 53.—Grossi, L. La claudicazione cere- brate dei cardiopatici. Cuore & circol., 1927, 11: 265-75.— Halbron, P. L'epilepsie cardiaque. Progr. med., Par., 1938, 342-52.—Urechia, C. L, & Dragomir, L. Hemipiegie avec amaurose unilaterale concomitante chez un cardiaque. Paris med., 1936, 101: 105.—Verhaart, W. J. C. [Catatonic symp- toms in organic heart disease] Psychiat. neur. bl., Amst., 1927, 31: 91-8.—Zilotti, L. Emiplegia in cardiopatia. Lat- tante, 1937, 8: 136-8. --- Nursing, and hygiene. Barth, K. Wie soil ein Herzkranker leben und wie soil man leben, um nicht herzkrank zu werden? 20p. 8? Munch., 1930. Carlisle, G. L. Practical talks on heart disease. 153p. 8? Springf. [19341 Lamberg, I. *L'hygiene des cardiaques. 41p. 8? Par., 1931. Levin, L. Living along with heart disease. 126p. 8? N. Y., 1936. Asher, A. G. Cardiac care other than rest and digitalis. J. Missouri M. Ass., 1933, 30: 229-34.------Improving the cardiac care in the small or community hospital. Ibid 1937, 34: 445-8.—Baltzan, D. M. The management of the cardiac case. Canad. M. Ass. J., 1935, 33: 281-6.—Bishop, L. F., jr, & Bennett, R. V. Living with heart disease. Hygeia Chic, 1941, 19: 708; passim.—Blaisdell, L. M. Home nursing care for cardiac children. Pub. Health Nurs., 1941, 33- 629-34— Boigey, M. Hygiene physique du cardiaque. Iii Ther. med. (Loeper, M.) Par., 1933, 6: 148-61.—Boucomont, R. Considerations sur l'hygiene des cardiaques. J. med chir., Par., 1939, 110: 310-8.—Care of persons with heart disease. J. Am. M. Ass., 1940, 115: 1387.—Coffen, T. H. The management of patients with heart disease. Northwest M., 1928, 27: 87-93.—Doane, J. C. Caring for cardiac pa- tients. Mod. Hosp., 1940, 55: No. 3, 84.—Engen, G. Nursing care in heart disease. Am. J. Nurs., 1931, 31: 406-10.— Felderhoff, M. M. Comparative nursing time study of 5 patients, all having cardiac involvements. Hosp. Progr., 1938, 19: 69-76.—Ferrannini, A. Come sorregere il cuore ammalato. Riforma med., 1937, 53: 743-8.—Fulton, F. T. Budgeting the reserve strength of the heart. Hygeia, Chic, 1935, 13: 1099; 1936, 14: 61.—Galli, G. I cardiaci che non hanno bisogno di cura medicamentosa. Umbria med., 1927, 7: 1235-7.—Jayne. M. Nursing care of the acutely ill cardiac patient. Am. J. Nurs., 1938, 38: 1325-30.—Kisch, F. Ueber die 24 Stunden-Rhythmik von Wachen-Schlafen und die kurative Bedeutung des Schlafes bei Herzkranken. Wien klin. Wschr., 1938, 51: 270-3.—Levine, H. B., & White, P. D. What sensible living and natural recovery can do far a cardiac patient. N. England J. M., 1941, 225: 101-5.—Lingg. C. Adult cardiac patients need more convalescent care. Nation's Health, Chic, 1926, 8: 751.—McCulloch, H. Gain in weight as a guide in the convalescent care of cardiac rhildren. Am. Heart J., 1925-26, 1: 569-75.—McMillan, T. M., & Stroud, W. D. Results in the convalescent care of 225 children with heart disease over a period of 5 years. Med. J. & Rec, 1927, 126: 300-2.—Minaker, A. J. Management of heart cases. Pacific Coast J. Homeop., 1934, 45: 242-56.—Ravin, A., & Ravin, R. S. The acutely ill cardiac patient. Am. J. Nurs., 1938, 38: 1318-24.—Reynolds, G. P. A practical mode of living for patients with damaged hearts. Med. Clin. N. America, 1935, 18: 1175-82.—Riesman, D. Treatment and guidance of patients with damaged hearts. Proc. Interst. Postgrad. M. Ass. N. America, 1936, 112-6.—Rosenblum, P. Convalescent care of cardiac children. Med. Clin. N. America, 1935, 18: 1471-84.—Shapiro, S. J. Cardiac care other than rest and digitalis. Eclect. M. J., 1935, 95: 377-9.—Taylor, A. M. Comforts for cardiac patients. Am. J. Nurs., 1938, 38: 768.—Zur, H. Der Herzkranke. Deut. med. Wschr., 1938, 64: 1481-4. ---- Occupational aspect. See also subheading Industrial aspect. Arenberg, H. Heart disease among United States Civil Service employees. Hosp. News, Wash., 1941, 8: No. 10, 21-5.—Blumberger, K. Berufsschadigungen des Herzens. Med. Klin., Berl., 1939, 35: 1245; 1260.—Carr, J. G. Heart disease as a general hazard in the practice of medicine. Bull. Chicago M. Soc, 1940-41, 43: 789.—Cason, T. Z. Cardiac diseases and their relation to occupation. J. Florida M. Ass., 1931-32, 18: 459-62.—Ginsberg, A. M. The doctor's heart. J. Missouri M. Ass., 1937, 34: 383-5.—Horine, E. F., & Weiss, M. M. Etiological types of heart disease in professional men with special reference to physicians. South. M. J., 1930, 23: 838-42.—Jokl, E. Zur Frage der Beurteilung von Herzfallen in der sport- und gewerbearztlichen Praxis. Med. Klin., Berl., 1933, 29: 1070; 1935, 31: 1163.—KoIIer, S. Ueber die Haufig- keit der Herzkrankheiten bei Lokomotivfiihrern. Zschr. Kreislaufforsch., 1934, 26: 240-8.—Kretschmer, W. Gibt es eine Herzberufskrankheit bei Lokomotivfiihrern? Verh Deut. Ges. Kreislaufforsch., 1936, 9: 250-6.—Langley, R. T. Heart disease in physicians. California West. M., 1936, 44: 381-5.—Moon, R. O. Heart disease and occupation. Prac- titioner, Lond., 1936, 137: 725-32.—Oppenheimer, R. H. Cardiac symptoms referable to occupation and habit. Med. Insur., 1927, 42: 497-500.—Sega, A., & Pozzi, E. II cuore dei marinai. Ber. Internat. Kongr. Unfallmed. (1938) 1939, 8. Congr., 2: 1188-90.—Wainwright, J. M. The question of the heart in railway engineers. Yearb. N. York N. England Ass. Railw. Surg., 1931, 38-51.—Waples, F. A. Prognostic standards for heart disease in railroad employees. Texas J. M., 1927-28, 23: 409-11.—Willius, F. A. A talk on cardiac disease among physicians. Proc. Mayo Clin., 1941, 16: 714-6. ---- Pathology. Ciba pharmaceutical products, inc. Major pathology of heart and aorta. Folder containing 8 col. pl. (3 fold.) with texts on versos. 23%cm. Summit, N. J., 1940. HEART DISEASE 276 HEART DISEASE Kirch, E. Pathologie des Herzens. p. 1-206. 8? Munch., 1927. Forms 1. Abt. v.22. Erg. aUg. Path., 1927, Baker. S. L., & Bramwell, J. C. Pathology of heart disease, Brit. M. J., 1936, 1: 500.—Burns, L. Osteopathic pathology of the heart. J. Am. Osteopath. Ass., 1933, 33: 59-63 — Ciocco, A. Studies on constitution; somatological differences associated with diseases of the heart in white females. Human Biol., 1936, 8: 38-91, pl. Also repr.—Clawson, B. J. Diseases of the heart. In Textb. Path. (Bell, E. T.) Phila., 4. ed., 1941, 519-49.— Czvhlarz, E. Beitrag zur Lehre der Herzpathologie. Wien. klin.' Wschr., 1929, 42: 617.—Dalla Torre, G. La ghiandola linfatica nei cardiopatici (linfoghiandola da stas!) Haematologica, Pavia, 1933, 14: 515-35.—Danielopolu, D., Lupu, N. G. [et al.] Recherches sur les alterations des nerfs cardiaques dans les lesions chroniques du cceur et de l'aorte; note preiiminaire sur les alterations du plexus cardiaque et aortique dans les lesions de l'aorte et des coronaires. Bull. Soc. med. hop. Bucarest, 1926, 8: 37-40, 4 pl.—De la Chapelle, C. E. The pathology of heart disease. Hosp. Social Serv., 1933, 28: Suppl. No. 2, 9-22, 35 pl. Also repr.—Hegge, E. [Pathology of the heart in the light of 6 months' post mortem examinations] Norsk mag. laegevid., 1930, 91: 265-79.—Kaufmann, R. Ueber autoptische Befunde bei Herzkrankheiten. Med. Klin., Berl., 1927, 23: 1919-23.—Mechanical embarrassment of the heart. South. Surgeon, 1937, 6: 172-4.—Mohler, H. K. Heart dis- ease: present day concepts of coronary artery disease and angina pectoris. Health Bull., Phila., 1940, Oct., 7-14.—Parsons- Smith, B. T. Right side diseases (heart) In Brit. Encycl. M. Pract. (Rolleston, H.) Lond., 1937, 6: 357-67, pl—Perkins, O. C, & Miller, A. M. Dynamics of histogenesis in cardiac repair; the role played bv connective tissue. Arch. Path., Chic, 1927, 3: 785-800.—Smith, F. M. ParaUehsm between tuberculosis and heart disease. J. Outdoor Life, 1927, 24: 457; 500.—Smith, I. H. Considerations of heart pathology. West Virginia M. J., 1934, 30: 272-4.—Taylor, J. Autopsies on cardiac cases. Lancet, Lond., 1935, 1: 325. ---- Pharmacology. See also under subheading Treatment. Gluckberg, A. *La diurese des cardiaques par association des diur^tiques mercuriels aux tonicardiaques. 46p. 8? Par., 1937. Kull, J. *Strophanthinwirkung und cholin- ergischer Mechanismus am Herz. p.447-56. 23cm. Basel, 1939. Also Arch. exp. Path., Berl., 1939, 192: Anichkov, S. V. [Pharmacotherapy of the heart from the view-point of experimental pharmacologyl KUn. med., Moskva, 1936, 14: 1097-104.—Aschenbrenner, R. Ueber renale und extrarenale Chlorausscheidung Herzkranker durch Salyrgan. Deut. Arch. kUn. Med., 1932, 174: 180-91.— Avegno, R. L'azione deU'estratto di Periploca greca d'ltalia nelle cardiopatie; studio clinico ed osciUografico. Cuore & circol., 1938, 22: 207-27.—Behr, V. Digitalis und Strophan- thin. Wien. med. Wschr., 1940, 90: 133-7.—Benzon, B. [Digitalis, strophanthin and helborsid in therapy of cardiac affections] LijeC. vjes., 1940, 62: 432-42.—Blakkolb, G. Einfluss von Wannen-, VoU- und Halbbadern auf des Herz. Gesundheitsdienst, 1940, No. 8, 9-12.—Bovet, D., Trefouel, J. [et al.] Action du diethylaminoethoxy-2-diphenyle (1262 F) sur la fibriUation cardiaque provoquee. C. rend. Soc. biol., 1939, 130: 29-31.—Boyson, W. A. Useful drugs in cardiac cases. Hahneman. Month., 1941, 76: 664-7.—Braude, S. G. Influence des agents physiotherapeutiques sur la restauration de l'activite du cceur altere; restauration de l'activite du cceur altete sous l'influence des rayons ultra-violets et infra-rouges. BuU. biol. med. exp. URSS, 1937, 4: 37—Biidingen, T. HeU- anzeigen fiir hypertonische Traubenzuckerinfusionen bei Herz- kranken. Fortsch. Ther., 1925, 1: 765-71.—Chen, K. K., & Elderfield, R. C. The cardiac action of the derivatives of strophanthidin and cymarin. J. Pharm. Exp. Ther., 1940, 70: 338-46. Also repr.—Crosetti, L. A apUcacao pratica do trata- mento cardiotonico. Resenha cUn. cient., S. Paulo, 1940, 9: 271-83.-—David, A. Comment prescrire les medicaments cardiaques. J. sc. med. LiUe, 1925, 43: 398; 415.—Dongen, K. van [Effect of camphor, cardiazol, coramine, hexeton, emetine and arethane on the heart action] Ned. tschr. geneesk., 1937, 81: 941.—Edens. E. Ueber DigitaUskumulation und lang- dauernde Strophanthinbehandlung. Klin. Wschr., 1936 15- 1829-32.—Frey, W., & Tiemann, F. Der Einfluss von Herz- mitteln (AdrenaUn, Campher, Strophanthin) auf die Phos- phatabgabe des geschadigten Herzens. Zschr. ges. exp Med 1926-27, 53: 658-65— Gorbatova, L. E., & Vasilieva, G. 1. [Combined action of urotropin and certain cardiac remedies] Farm. de una observaci6n clfnica. In Libro de oro M. R. Castex, B. Air., 1938, 2: 916-22.—Nagl. F. Ueber Veranderungen des diskordanten Lacvogramms unter Amylnitrit-Inhalation. Klin. Wschr., 1935, 14: 1461-4.— I'ick, E. P. DigitaUs and strophanthin; their relative therapeutic values and practical use. j. Mount Sinai Hosp. N. York, 1940-41, 7: 181-93— Piery, M., Enselme, .1.. & Nury, D. Action cardio-vasculaire de divers typos de bains mineraux, chlorutes sodiques de Salins-Moutiers sulfates chlorutes et bains de mousse de Brides. Presse therm, clim., 1938, 79: 289.—Podolsky, E. The cardiotherapeutics of the alkaline earth salts: calcium, potassium, barium. Med. Rec, N. Y., 1936, 143:208-11.—Quintin Olascoaga, J. Principales acciones fisiolwgicas de la combinaci6n azucar-insulina en therap6utica cardfaca. Arch. lat. amer. card., Mex., 1932-33, 3: 143-79 — Russo, G. Ueber die Wirkung intravenoser Zufuhr hyper- tonischer Kochsalzlosung auf die Albumine und Globuline des Serums und auf die Blut- und Serumviscositat bei Gesunden und Herzkranken. Zschr. ges. exp. Med., 1939, 105: 149- 54.—Scholten, C. Ueber experimentelle und therapeutische Grundlagen der Scfalafmittelanwendung nach Erfahrungen bei Herzkranken. Med. Welt, 1940, 14: 961-5.—Schwartz, S. P.. & Schwedel, J. B. Digitalis studies on children with heart disease; the effects of digitalis on the sinus rate of children with rheumatic fever and chronic valvular heart disease. Am. J. Dis. Child., 1930, 39: 298-315. Also repr.—Sribner, I. M. [Fangotherapy and the heart] Ter. arkh., 1936, 14: 408-15.— Stefl, J., & Kolar, V. [The mechanism of the action of cardio- tonics] Cas. lek. eesk., 1937, 76: 799-801, 2 pl.—Sterkin, E. I., Lomakin, P. F. [et al.] [On lactic acid therapy in diseases of the heart] Vrach. delo, 1939, 21: 451-6.—Stewart, H. J. The effect of increased heart rate due to the injection of atropine on the oxygen saturation of the arterial and venous blood of patients with heart disease. J. Clin. Invest., 1926-27, 3: 241- 51.—Untersteiner, L. Azione della dietilamide dell'acido 3-5- dimetU-isooxazol-4-carbonico sul cuore di Rana isolato; azione sul cuore ipodinamico. Boll. Soc. ital. biol. sper., 1939, 14: 341-3.—Uva, E. Azione della corteccia surrenale sulla resintesi dell'acido lattico nei cardiopatici. Cuore & circol., 1940, 24: 129-38.—Weiss, M. M. The armamentarium of cardiac therapy. Kentucky M. J., 1939, 37: 409-12.—Zimmermann- Meinzingen, O. von, & Cicovadki, D. Ueber Helborsid und seine Beziehungen zur Strophanthin-Therapie. Munch, med. Wschr., 1938, 85: 505-9. ---- Physiopathology. Monckeberg, J. G. Die anatomischen Grundlagen der normalen und pathologischen Herztatigkeit; ein nicht gehaltencr Vortag. 24p. 8? Dresd., 1919. Ascarelli, E. Rapporti tra velocity, di corrente e metabolismo basale nei cardiopazienti. Cuore & circol., 1938, 22: 44-54 — Benedetti, P. La portata circolatoria e la gittata sistolica in rapporto alia grandezza tridimensionale del cuore nei cardio- pazienti. Arch, pat., Bologna, 1937-38, 17: 150-95.—Borgard, W. Herzfrequenz und Herzleistungssteigerung. Arbeits- physiologie, 1935-37, 9: 505-13.—Biittner, H. E. Ueber Muskelkurven bei Herzkranken und Gesunden. Zschr. ges. exp. Med., 1929, 67: 571-81.—Crandall, L. A., jr. Phvsiulogic considerations in cardiac disease. Northwest M., 1936, 35: 52-9.—De Flora, G., & Ciravegna, M. Le variazioni della massa sanguigna dei cardiopatici nei cambiamenti di decubito. Cuore & circol., 1937, 21: 396-405.—Eismayer, G., & Quincke, H. Ueber Dynamik, Grosse und Formge.staltung des normalen und geschadigten Herzens. Verh. Deut. Ges. inn. Med., 1929, 41. Kongr., 396.—Estable, C. Investigaciones sobre histo- fisiologla e histofisiopatologfa del coraz6n. Arch. urug. med., 1933, 3: 1-36.—Gilbeau, W., Marzahn, H., & Zaeper, G. KUnische Untersuchungen iiber die Funktion von Atmung und Kreislauf bei Gesunden und Kranken; Methoden; Grenzen der Arbeitsbelastung bei Herz- und Lungenkranken. Zschr. klin. Med., 1935-36, 129: 254-68.—Gunther-^aeper. Limites d'activite du cceur chez I'homme bien portant et chez le malade. BruxeUes med., 1937-38, 18: 1583-9.—Harris, I., & Lipkin, I. J. Cardiac output and oxygen utiUsation in some types of heart disease. Edinburgh M. J., 1931, 38: 501-21—Jankowsky, W. Zur Herzphysiologie am Krankenbett. Fortsch. Med., 1926, 44: 873 6.—Kabanov, N. A. [What is compensation.') Klin. med., Moskva, 1931, 9: 473-83.—Master, A.M. Kflort, trauma, occupation and compensation in heart disease. Bull. N. York Acad. M., 1941, 17: 778- 95— Miassinkov, A. L., & Abdulaev, D. M. [Rate cf blood circulation in heart diseasesl Ter. arkh., 1933, 11: 326-31.—Museer, J. H. The normal and the diseased heart. J. Oklahoma M. Ass., 1931, 24: 225-33.— Olmes de Carrasco, H. Die Vollstandigkeit der arteriellen Siittigung beim Herzkranken unter korperlic her Arbeit. Klin. Wschr., 1941, 20: 95-7.—Raisbeck, M. J. Clinical cardiology; abnormal cardiac mechanism. Long Island M. J., 1928, 22: 343-9.— Revers, F. E. [Recent views on disturbances of the organism HEART DISEASE 277 HEART DISEASE in heart patients] Geneesk. bl., 1931, 29: 1-39.—Scheinflnkel, N. Untersuchungen uber die Abhangigkeit der Arbeitsleistung des Froschherzens von den mechanischen Faktoren mit be- sonderer Berucksichtigung der Kompensationsmoglichkeiten. Zschr. Biol., 1929-30, 89: 171; 1930-31, 91: 322.—Sokolowsky, V P [Changes of minute volume in heart affections in Kislo- vodsk) KUn. med., Moskva, 1938, 16: 657-64.—Straub, H. Pathologie der Herzarbeit. Arch. exp. Path., Lpz., 1928, 138: 31-50.—Takayasu, M., & Koizumi, H. Studies on the patho- logic physiology of the function of the heart. Jap. J. M. Sc, 1938-39, 5: Int. Med., 229.—Tzukerstein, E. I. [Answer to N A Kabanov's article: what is compensation?] Klin, med., Moskva, 1931, 9: 483-9. ---- Preclinical stage. Benoit, E. P. Lesions cardiaques silencieuses. Bull. Soc med. hop. Paris, 1926, 3. ser., 50: 976-9.—Brams. W. A. Occult heart disease. Med. Clin. N. America, 1937-38, 21: 235-9 —Burwell, C. S. The management of asymptomatic heart disease. Internat. Clin., 1937, 47. ser., 2: 249-59 — Macera, J. M., & Ruchelli, A. P. Concepto de las cardiopatias en potencia basado en la evolution de varios anos de observa- ci6n de las mismas. Dia med., B. Air., 1940, 12: 994.—Smith, S. C. The preclinical stage of heart disease. J. Am. M. Ass., 1926, 86: 1902. ---- Prevention. See also Digitalis, Therapeutic use: Indications, preventive. Hart, T. S. Taking care of your heart. 72p. 16? N. Y., 1924. Knopf, S. A. Heart disease and tuberculosis; efforts including methods of diaphragmatic and costal respiration to lessen their prevalence. 108p. 8? N. Y., 1936. Stephens, G. A. The heart and spleen in health and disease. 139p. 8? Lond., 1932. Thomson, J. C. The heart; the prevention and cure of cardiac conditions. 143p. 8? Lond. [1937] Williamson. B. Vital cardiology; a new outlook on the prevention of heart failure. 343p. 8? Edinb., 1934. Alsaker, R. Heart diseases. Health Cult., N. Y., 1941, 47: No. 8, 10. ------ You can build a strong heart. Phys. Cult., N. Y., 1941, 85: No. 3, 16.—Arcangeli, U. Indirrizzo aUa profilassi e cura delle malattie cardiache. Riv. osp., 1930, 20: 419-37.—Bachmann, H. A. The prevention of heart disease in childhood. Med. CUn. N. America, 1926, 9: 1531- 40. Also Pub. Health Nurse, 1929, 21: 306-9—Barbato, D. Consideraciones sobre la acci6n profilactica del salicilato de soda en las cardiopatfas infantUes. Arch, pediat. Uruguay, 1939, 10: 212-21.—Bauer, E. L. The prevention of heart disease in chUdren. Proc. Interst. Postgrad. M. Ass. N. America, 1933, 339-45. ------ Heart disease prevention versus heart salvage. Med. CUn. N. America, 1933, 17: 639-45.—Bishop, L. F., jr. The prevention of heart disease. West Virginia M. J., 1937, 33: 437-44.—Brooks, H. The care of the heart in the acute infections. Proc. Interst. Postgrad. M. Ass. N. America (1928) 1929, 503 10.—Bush, L. M. Heart troubles. Health Cult., N. Y., 1941, 47: No. 9, 18; 55.— Cavagliano, B. La prevenzione deU'invalidity da malattie di cuore. Med. lavoro, 1927, 18: 258-66.—DeOgny, P. A. The prevention of heart disease. Nat. Eclect. M. Ass. Q., 1934-35, 26: 172-5.—Dever, F. J. Some aspects of the treatment of heart affections; the prevention of heart disease. Pennsyl- vania M. J., 1929-30, 32: 219-21.—Discours de M. Laubry, President. Arch. mal. coeur, 1938, 31: 659.—Fischer, E. Prophylaxis against lethal effect of high altitude by means of digitalis glycoside, gitaUn. Am. Heart J., 1941, 21: 545-50.— Fordyce, A. D. The prevention of heart disease. J. State M., Lond., 1928, 36: 373-85.—Frick, D. J. Heart disease; the necessity for its cure and prevention. Southwest. M., 1929, 13: 291-5.—Friedmann, J. Zur Frage der prophylaktischen Tonisierung des Herzens. Schweiz. med. Wschr., 1927, 57: 1027-9.—Gager, L. T. Heart disease; its nature, study, and prevention. Am. J. Nurs., 1931, 31: 397-406.—Gambigliani Zoccoli, A. Sulla digitalizzazione preventiva. Gior. Accad. med. Torino, 1939, 102: pt 2, 245-50—Guglielmini, T. Ri- conoscimento profilattico deUe malattie di cuore nell'infanzia. Prat, pediat., Milano, 1938, 16: 113-7— Hamburger, W. W. The administration of digitalis in the presence of certain acute infections. Med. Clin. N. America, 1921, 5: 101-14.—Hart, A. P. The prevention of heart disease. Health, Toronto, 1933, 1: No. 2, 10; 15.—Helbichova, A. [Significance of the possibility of prevention and therapy of cardiac diseases] Cas. 16k.' Cesk., 1940, 79: 473-6.—Herrick, J. B. What can the hospital do to prevent and relieve heart disease? Tr. Am. Hosp. Ass., 1923, 25: 539-43.—Keith, J. D. Be careful of your child's heart. Health, Toronto, 1941, 9: 9.—Kerr, F. WPA helps check heart disease. J. Health Phys. Educ, 1941, 12: 154.—Knopf, S. A. Heart disease and tuberculosis; medical, surgical and social measures to lessen their prevalence. Med. Rec, N. Y., 1935, 141: 562; 586.—Kopecky, J. The prevention of heart disease. Texas J. M., 1938-39, 34: 331-4.— Lambert, A. The prevention of heart disease. Atlantic M. J., 1925-26, 29: 283-9.—Lindsey, W. H., & Talley, J. E. The prevention of heart disease m children. Ibid., 752-5.— Lotz, O. Thirty-eight million times every year. Wisconsin M. J., 1926, 25: 25-8.—Mancini. S. Profilassi delle malattie del cuore. In his Probl. sociale, Livorno, 1938, 55-62.— Martins Ferrcira, J. As vantagens dos exames medicos peri6dicos e a incidfincia das lesoes cardfacas entre as crianeas e adolescentes. Rev. Arq. mun., S. Paulo, 1939-40, 6: No. 67, 167-72.—Marvin, H. M. The prevention of heart disease. Tn Pract. Libr. M. & S. (Appleton) N. Y., 1937, 12: 759-65.— Powell, R. V. The prevention of heart disease. Clin. M. & S., 1934, 41: 469.—Prentice, N. Exercise makes stout-hearted men. Phys. Cult., N. Y., 1941, 85: No. 2, 26.—Rentschler, E. B. The importance of periodic health examinations relative to heart disease. Pennsylvania M. J., 1938-39, 42: 139-41.— Rice, L. The prevention of heart disease. Texas J. M., 1928-29, 24: 484-6.—Riggin, I. C. Heart disease, prevention and after care. Illinois M. J., 1931, 60: 219-24.—Roberts, S. R. Heart disease and life. Ann. Clin. M., 1925-26, 4: 535-40.—Robey, W. H. Prevention of heart disease. N. England J. M., 1930, 202: 983-90.—Rovirosa, G. L. Para evitar y curar las enfermedades del corazon. Arch. rev. hosp., Habana, 1935, 1: No. 4, 14-8.—Sedillot, J. La medecine preventive pour le coeur en clientele. Prat. med. fr., 1933, 14: 795-811.—Shapiro, M. J. The prevention of heart disease in children. J. Lancet, 1927, 47: 16-8.—Sherman, A. Care for little hearts. Health, Mount. View, 1941, 8: 3.—Skinner, G. A. The engine of that marvelous machine. Ibid., 12.— Sprague, H. B., & White, P. D. The etiology of heart disease with special reference to the present status of the prevention of heart disease. J. Am. M. Ass., 1935, 105: 1391-4. Also Med. Off., Lond., 1936, 55: 55-7.—Talley, J. E. Can we prevent heart disease? Med. Clin. N. America, 1932, 16: 11-20 — Townsend, M. L. Health education to prevent heart disease. South. M. J., 1926, 19: 271-5.—Viehoever, A. The heart. Am. J. Pharm., 1928, 100: 718-45.—W., N. C. Heart disease to the fore. A-V, Phila., 1940, 48: 53.—Washburn, A. H. The prevention of heart disorders in early life. Colorado M., 1931, 28: 338-45.—White, P. D. The prevention of heart disease. Virginia M. Month., 1930-31, 57: 139-46. ------ Prevention of heart disease in children. Child Health BuU., 1935, 11: 45.—Willius, F. A. The prevention of heart disease. Minnesota M., 1929, 12: 355-9.—Wilson, R., jr. The prev- alence and prevention of heart disease. South. M. & S., 1927, 89: 151-5.—Wood, J. E., jr. The etiology and prevention of heart disease. Virginia M. Month., 1933, 60: 67-71.— Woughter, M. L. Newer methods in conserving cardiac efficiency. Pub. Health Nurs., 1927, 19: 12-4.—Wylder, M. K. Prevention.of heart disease. Southwest. M., 1935, 19: 18-22. ---- Prognosis. Abrahams, R. Factors determining the prognosis of chronic heart disease. Psychiat. Q., 1928, 2: 13-21— Anderson, K. W. Heart lesions from an insurance standpoint. J. Lancet, 1938, 58: 32-6.—Boas, E. P. False alarms in heart disease. Hygeia, Chic, 1939, 17: 299.—Candel, S., & Rabinowitz, M. A. Blood velocity rate and venous pressure in the prognosis of heart disease. Ann. Int. M., 1936-37, 10: 1000-13.—Carr, J. G. Prognosis in cardiac disease. Illinois M. J., 1937, 72: 269-74. Also Kansas City M. J., 1941, 17: No. 3, 7-13.—CoIIatz. B. Die Lebensaussichten bei den verschiedenen organischen Herzleiden. Zschr. Zellforsch., 1932, 16: 673-9.—Cowan, J. M. Prognosis of chronic heart disease: observations based on the study of the individual case. Tr. R. Med. Chir. Soc. Glasgow, 1933-34, 28: 67-72.—Cross, J. G. Some factors in the prognosis of heart disease. Med. J. & Rec, 1928, 127: 639-42.—Davidson, H. S., & Leaman, W. G., jr. Cardiac prognosis is better. Tr. Am. Ther. Soc. (1939) 1940, 39: 95-104.—Eppinger, E. C, & Burwell, C. S. Curable heart disease. Med. Clin. N. America, 1940, 24: 1347-64— Faber, K. [Prognosis in chronic heart diseases] Hospitalstidende, 1930 73: 461-72.—Falk, O. P. J. Prognosis in heart disease. Illinois M. J., 1934, 66: 126-33.—Gager, L. T. Grounds for optimism in cardiac prognosis. South. M. & S., 1928, 90: 728-32.—Geiger, A. J. Curable heart disease. Internat. Clin., 1941, n. ser. (4) 1: 129-39, pl.—Gibson, A. G. Some observations dealing with prognosis in heart disease. Ibid., 1935 45. ser., 2: 1-15.—Grant, R. T. The prognosis of heart disease. Bull. N. York Acad. M., 1933, 2. ser., 9: 500-2. After-histories for 10 years of 1,000 men suffering from heart disease; a study in prognosis. Heart, Lond., 1933, 16: 275-483.—Hamburger, W. W. Prognosis in cardiac diseases. J. Lancet, 1932, 52: 323-8—Hammond, J. J., Gallagher, W. J. [et al.] Symposium on curable heart disease. Week. BuU. S. Louis M. Soc, 1940-41, 35: 304-9.—Hasenfeld, \. [Prognosis of chronic heart disease] Gy6gy£szat, 1939, 79: 302-317; 336. ------ Die Prognose der Herzkrankheiten in'neue'rer Beleuchtung. Zschr. arztl. Fortbild 1931, 28: 649" 687 Also in Bain. & Balneother. Karlsbad (1930) 1931, 12- 25-56 —Holbrook, R. W. The prognosis of heart disease. J. Missouri M. Ass., 1931, 28: 469-70.—Holmes a Court, A. W. Factors in the prognosis of cardiac disease. Med. J. Australia, 1938, 2: 361-7.—Horine, E. F., & Weiss, M. M. The in- fluence of etiologv on prognosis in heart disease. Kentucky M J 1931, 29:'233-5.—Hull, E. Curable diseases of the heart." Tristate M. J., 1935-36, 8: 1696; 1700.—Hurley, L. E. HEART DISEASE 27S HEART DISEASE The principles governing prognosis in heart disease. Med. J. Australia, 1932, 2: 677-82.—Jensen. J. Prognosis in heart disease. J. Kansas M. Soc, 1940, 41: 45-50.—Kaliebe, H. Prognostik des Herzens bei Jugendlichcn. Deut. Militararzt, 1938, 3: 354-7.—Leaman, W. G. The prognosis in heart disease with special reference to curable tvpes. Internat. CUn., 1939, n. ser. (2) 3: 130-45, pl —Levine, S. A. Factors con- cerning prognosis in heart disease. N. England J. M., 1932, 207: 173-8.—McMillan, T. M. An optimistic view of the problems of heart disease. J. M. Ass. Alabama, 1938-39, 8: 133-40.—Majumdar, A. R. Prognosis in heart diseases. Calcutta M. J., 1941, 38: 361-70—Markwell, N. W. Per- spective in the examination, prognosis and treatment in heart disease. Med. J. AustraUa, 1933, 2: 97-110.—Master, A. M. Optimism in heart disease. Hygeia, Chic, 1938, 16: 594-6.— Moon, R. O. Prognosis in diseases of the heart. Practitioner, Lond., 1932, 128: 159-68.—Reid, J. W. The prognosis and care of heart cases in general practice. Tr. Hunterian Soc, Lond., 1938-39, 3: 107-35.—Remote prognosis in heart disease. Flight Surgeon Topics, 1937, 1: No. 3, 84.—Rudolf, R. D. The immediate and ultimate prognosis in cardiac disease. Canad. M. Ass. J., 1927, 17: 11-6. ------ The prognosis in cardiac disorders. Ibid., 1933, 28: 35-40.—Schleussing, H. Pathologisch-anatomische Erhebungen zur Lebensaussicht Herzkranker. Zschr. klin. Med., 1937-38, 133: 575-87.— Seltzer, J. G. The prognosis in heart disease. J. Florida M. Ass., 1939-40, 26: 180-6.—Siebeck. Die Beurteilung und Behandlung Herzkranker. Miinch. med. Wschr., 1930, 77: 1370; 1406; 1451.—Smith, H. Prognosis in heart disease. S. Afr. M. Rec, 1926, 24: 442-50.—Stern, N. S. Prognosis in heart disease. Memphis M. J., 1940, 15: 133.—Walker, H. F. B. Prognosis in heart disease. S. Afr. M. J., 1938, 12: 491; 527.—White, P. D. The immediate and ultimate prog- nosis in heart disease. Proc. Interst. Postgrad. M. Ass. N. America, 1938, 130-4.—Willius, F. A. Prognosis in heart disease. Med. Insur., 1931, 46: 163; 489. Also Minnesota M., 1931, 11: 405-10. ------ A talk on the philosophy of con- valescence. Proc. Mayo Clin., 1940, 15: 822-4. ---- Psychological aspect. Kingsbury, C E. *The social and economic importance of heart disease [Marquette Univ.] 36p. 8? Mihvaukee, Wis., 1932. Abrahams, R. Facts and fancies in heart disease. Psy- chiat. Q.. 1930, 4: 404-13.—Banuelos Garcia, M. Sobre trastornos cardfacos de origen psic6geno. Inform, med., Valladolid, 1930, 7: 207-12.—Blackburn, C. B. The nervous factors in disorders of the heart. Med. J. Australia, 1934, 1: 829-36.—Braun. L. Ueber die Psyche des Herzkranken. Wien. med. Wschr., 1928, 78: 331. Also Zschr. Psychol. Physiol. Sinnesorg., 1. Abt., 1928, 106: 1-22.—Brooks, H. Heart disease from the standpoint of the patient. Proc Interst. Postgrad. M. Ass. N. America (1929) 1930, 5: 230-5.— Conner, L. A. The psychic factor in cardiac disorders. J. Am, M. Ass., 1930, 94: 447-52— Fahrenkamp, K. Psychoso- matische Beziehungen beim Herzkranken. Nervenarzt, 1929, 2: 607-71(1.—Foster, N. B. Psychic factors in the course of cardiac disease. J. Am. M. Ass., 1927, 89: 1017.—Horine, E. F. Psychological factors in cardiology. J. Indiana M. Ass., 1939, 32: 675-7.—Husemann, F. Herz und Psyche. Psychiat. neur. Wschr., 1939, 41: 199.—Klemperer, G. Gemutsbe- negungen und Herzkrankheit. Ther. Gegenwart, 1929, 70: 1-5.—Maroon, J. L. My heart shall not fear. Health, Mount. View, 1941, 8: No. 12, 12.—Menninger, K. A., & Menninger, W. C. Psychoanalytic observations in cardiac disorders. Am. Heart J., 1936, 11: 10-21.—Moros, N. Psychic factors in heart disease. Med. Bull. Veterans Admin., 1937-38, 14: 329-33.—Pliigge, H. Ueber die Psychophysik Herzkranker. Deut. med. Wschr., 1936, 62: 373; 420.—Podolsky, E. What worry does to the heart. Health Cult., N. Y., 1941, 47: No. 2, 40.—Silver, H. B. The emotional and social develop- ment of girls with heart disease. J. Pediat., S. Louis, 1938, 12: 218-42.-—Sprague, H. B. Mental adjustments to heart disease; the factors involved in disabihty. J. Am. M. Ass., 1939, 112: 2384.—Ward, G. E. S. Heart and mind. Individ. Psychol. M. Pamphl., Lond., 1935, No. 15, 43-59.—Werley, G. Heart symptoms due to the emotions. Southwest. M., 1931, 15: 23-7.—Wolfe, T. P. Emotions and organic heart disease. Am. J. Psychiat., 1936-37, 93: 681-91.—Wyckoff, J. Psycho- genic heart disease. BuU. N. York Acad. M., 1928, 2. ser. 4: 437-40. ---- Public health and social aspect. See also subheading Social service. Ambrosio, A. II problema sociale delle cardiopatie croniche Studium, Nap., 1935, 25: 301-8.—Atkinson, H. C. The changing emphasis in heart disease. J. M. Ass. Georgia 1938 27: 257-60.—Barrett, P. S. PubUc health aspects of heart disease in children. J. Health Phys. Educ, 1941, 12: 155; 196.—Barth, K. Das Nachlassen der Herzkraft und seine soziale Bedeutung. Med. Welt, 1936, 10: 1294-6.—Benjamin, J. E. Some present day ideas concerning heart disease from the publie health point of view. Ohio M. J., 1932, 28: 843-8.— Bergholz. E. A. Why fear heart trouble. Health Cult. N Y 1941, 47: No. 6, 20; 52— Burwell, C. S. The problem of heart disease. J. Tennessee M. Ass., 1U34, 27: 111-5.—Cattaneo, A. Le malattie del cuore. Riv. Soc ital. it \ irginia M. J., 1935, 31: 115-9—Smith, K. S. Insulin and glucose in the treatment of heart disease with special reference to angina pectoris. Brit. M. J., 1933, l- 693-6— Wiener, J. L'insulinotherapie dans les affections cardiaques. BruxeUes med., 1932-33, 13: 188-91. ---- Treatment: Methods. Bilfixuer, O. Biologische Schonungshe- handlung des Herzens. Tip. 20}2cm. Berl., 1938. Aubertin, C. Le traitement antisyphiUtique chez les cardi- aques. Bull. Soc. med. hop. Paris, 1927, 3. ser., 51: 1586.— Bain, C. The modern treatment of diseases of the heart. Practitioner, Lond., 1933, 131: 400-8.—Barach, A. L. The therapeutic use of oxygen in heart disease. Ann. Int. M 1931, 5: 428-40.—Bauke, E. E. Durch Elektrokardiogramm- Auswertung zielbare, praktische Herztherapie-Moglichkeiten Fortsch. Ther., 1937, 13: 493-500.—Birdsall, G. C. Serious heart conditions treated and cured homeopathically. J. Am. Inst. Homeop., 1935, 28: 10-2.—Bishop, L. F. The practice of cardiology; a consideration of the continuous care of heart patients by the prolonged use of drugs, physiotherapy and psychotherapy. Ann. Int. M., 1928, 2: 352 66.—Boericke, G. W. Homeopathy in heart disease. Hahneman. Month., 1934, 69: 336-41.—Cautru. Le massage precordial dans les maladies du coeur. C. rend. Congr. internat. physiotWr. (1905) 1906, 1. Congr., 49.—Eppinger, H. Ueber Massage als Heilfaktor bei Herzkranken. Verh. Deut. Ges. inn. Med., 1929, 41. Kongr., 337-46. ------& Hinsberg, K. Ueber die MogUckheit einer peripheren Behandlung der Herzkranken. Khn. Wschr., 1928, 7: 2284-6.—Famiglietti, G. Contributo aUa terapia delle malattie cardiache. Pensiero med., 1927, 16: 239-43.—Fisichella, G. B. Recenti acquisizioni di terapia in alcune forme di cardiopatie. Cult. med. mod., Pal., 1939, 18: 377-87.—Flandin, C, Poumeau-Delille, G. [et al.l Deux cas de cardiopathies chroniques ameiiores par 1'oxygenotherapie. Bull. Soc. med. hop. Pans, 1939, 3. ser., 55: 170-3.— Galatzer, N. Konstitutionstherapie bei Herzleiden. Hippokrates, Stuttg., 1933, 4: 56-62.—Gemelli, B. Contributo alia terapia delle malattie cardiache. Pensiero med., 1927, 16: 110; 129.— Goldscheider. Zur peripherischen Behandlung Herzkranker. Klin. Wschr., 1929, 8: 263.—Holzmann. Neue amerikanische Behandlungsmethoden bei Herzkrankheiten. Praxis, Bern, 1936, 25: 323-5.—Kaufmann, E. Zur Verringerung der Gefahren der intravenosen Herztherapie. Miinch. med. Wschr., 1926, 73: 2018.—Kovalenok, M. I. [Microenemas in treatment of heart diseases] Klin, med., Moskva, 1933,11: 885-8. Also Sovet. vrach. gaz., 1933, 37: 628-32.—Lam pert, H. Was wissen wir uber Massage und ihre Anwendung bei Herzkranken? Arch. Verdauungskr., 1932, 52: 238. Also Zbl. inn. Med., 1932, 53: 1336.—Langeron, Pernet & Torek. Cardiopathie grave, guerie par application de tubes de Southey aptes echec de la therapeutique habituelle. J. sc. med. Lille, 1930, 48: 355-8.— Oks, A. A., Tovbina, E. L., & Feldstein, A. G. [Combined methods in treatment of cardiac patients] In Kardiol. sess., Odessa, 1935, 1. Congr., 197-200.—Pruche, A. La teflexo- therapie et le cceur. Bull. Soc. med. Paris, 1934, 455-60.— Bitter, H. Homoopathische Beitrage zur Herzbehandlung. Jahrkurs. arztl. Fortbild., 1938, 29: H. 8, 45-56.—Roberts, H. A. The findings of the homoeopathic remedy in heart condi- tions. Homoeop. Rec, 1938, 53: No. 4, 19-25.—Sauer, H. Die homoopathische Behandlung von Herzkranken. Med. Welt, 1935, 9: 299-301.—Shchupak, N. B. [Use of duodenal tube in therapy of cardiac diseases] Klin, med., Moskva, 1936, 14: 1503-7.—Simmons, A. H. Some practical applications in the treatment of heart disease. Freedmen Hosp. Bull., 1934, 1: 18-24.—Simon, H. Ueber die Wirkung von Sauerstollin- halationen und ihre Verwertbarkeit in der Herztherapie. Klin. Wschr., 1926, 5: 1880. Also Zschr. ges. phys. Ther., 1926, 32: 8-23.—Snowden, W. M. Clinical homeopathic therapeutics for Crataegus in cardiac conditions. Hahneman. Month., 1939, 74: 556-8.—Strauss, A. E. Occupational therapy; its place in heart disease. Occup. Ther. Rehabil., 1936, 15: 163- 9.—Terry, E. Occupational therapy in heart disease from the socia.1 standpoint. Ibid., 1941, 20: 21-30.—Veil, P. Essai d'unification des diverses cardiopathies fonctionnelles et organiques; l'etat de defaillance favorable dans le syndrome cardiaque; du role therapeutique du tubage duodenal dans cct etat. Quest, med. actual., Par., 1937, 7: 1-12.—Viko, L. E. Modern treatment of heart disease. Med. Rec, N. Y., 1938, 148: 260-3.—Weil, L. Neue Wege bei der Behandlung von Herzkrankheiten. Deut. Aerzte Ztg., 1933, 8: No. 363.— White, P. D. Occupational therapy in heart disease. Occup. Ther. Rehabil., 1941, 20: 13-9.—Willius, F. A. Newer methods in the treatment of diseases of the heart. Northwest M., 1926, 25: 348-55.—Zarday, I. [Venesection in heart diseases] Orv. hetil., 1936, 80: mell., 41.—Zemetz, A. A., & Mikheleva, V. L. [Rectal therapy in diseases of the heart] Vrach. gaz., 1930, 34: 1417-20. ---- Treatment: Physiotherapy. Alquier, L. La physiotherapie teflexogene chez les cardia- ques. Arch. mal. cceur, 1935, 28: 597-603.—Becker, A. D. Manipulative osteopathy in cardiac therapy. J. Am. Osteo- path. Ass., 1938-39, 38: 317-9.—Berger, E. Sulla terapia fisica delle cardiopatie; meccanoterapia. Rass. internaz. clin. ter., 1926, 7: 687; 752; 797.—Bettmann, E. Low voltage wave current in vascular therapy. Arch. Phys. Ther., 1938, 19: 633-6.—Borak, J. The influence of ovarian irradiation upon organic heart disease. Radiol. Rev., 1933, 55: 1-7. Also Zschr. kUn. Med., 1932, 121: 678- Campbell, J. M. H., & Sale. F. J. Effect of exercise on respiratorv exchange in heart disease. Arch. Int. M., 1927, 40: 237-50.—Cyriax, E. F. La base HEART DISEASE 285 HEART DISEASE physiologique du traitement kinesitherapique des maladies du cceur. Ann. med. phys., Anvers, 1929, 22:71-6. Also Internat. Clin., 1930, 40. ser., 2: 15-28.—Desjardins, A. U. Action of roentgen rays and radium on the heart and lungs. Am. J. Roentg., 1932, 27: 153; 305; 477.—Echtman, J. Mercury quartz lamp in cardiology. Med. J. & Rec, 1926, 124: 708- 10.—Ettenreich, R. Eine Anregung zum Thema der physi- kalischen Herztherapie. Wien. klin. Wschr., 1936, 49: 1365.— Facto, L. L. Baths, exercise, and diathermy in the treatment of chronic cardiac disorders. J. Am. Osteopath. Ass., 1941-42, 41: 144-7.—Fogelson, L. I., & Pasynkov, E. I. [Rhythmic faradization with the aid of Bergonier's chair in chronic state of collapse] Fizioterapia, Moskva, 1939, 96-101.—Freund, E. In welcher Weise findet die Mechanotherapie bei Herzkrank- heiten Anwendung? Wien. klin. Wschr., 1927, 40: 359 — Galli, T. La cura delle cardiopatie con rontgenterapia anti- tiroidea. Cuore & circol., 1938, 22: 32-43.—Garrigues, L. F. A new specific electrical treatment for heart affections. Am. J. Phys. Ther., 1927-28, 4: 11-6.—Gutman, J. Physical therapy in cardiac disease. Arch. Phys. Ther., 1931, 12: 401- 8 —Kottmaier, J. Rontgentherapie bei Herzkrankheiten. Fortsch. Ther., 1927, 3: 853-9.— Lachnit, V., & Zollner, S. Die therapeutische Wirkung lokaler Kalteapplikation auf das Herz. Wien. klin. Wschr., 1939, 52: 208-12.—Lacqueur, A. Electro-physiotherapy in heart disease. Am. J. Phys. Ther., 1931, 8: 48-50.—Mann, L. Ueber die Wirkungsweise der Elektrotherapie bei Herzschwache und Zirkulationsstorungen. Zschr. ges. phys. Ther., 1930, 39: 162-72.—Nagera, J. M. La kinesiologfa en cardiologia. Prensa med. argent., 1941, 28: pt 2, 1584-8.—Peto, S. [Mechanotherapy in affections of the heart] Gv6gyaszat, 1926, 66: 345.—Plate, E. Physical therapy in heart disease. Am. J. Phys. Ther., 1929, 6: 221-4. Also Brit. J. Actinother., 1929, 4: 79-81.—Podolsky, E. Physical therapy in heart disease. Arch. Phys. Ther., 1933, 14: 554-9. ----- X-rays and diathermy in heart disease. Hahneman. Month., 1940, 75: 403-7.—Pope, C. Cardiac diseases. Am. J. Phys. Ther., 1926, 3: 459-61. ------ Physical treatment of cardiac diseases. Clin. Med., 1926, 33: 858.—Pruche, A., & Bienvenue, A. Radiotherapie sympathique dans certaines affections cardiaques. Bull, med., Par., 1929, 43: 9-12.— Raab, L., & Raab, E. W. Die Elektrotherapie der Herzkrank- heiten und ihre kymographische Kontrolle. Miinch. med. Wschr., 1934, 81: 209-12.—Schurig, A. Sinn und Zweck der elektrischen Behandlung des Herzens. Med. Welt, 1935, 9: 304; 1936, 10: 59.—Terrizzano, V. M. La terapeutica kinesica en los cardfacos. Prensa med. argent., 1931-32, 18: 855-60.— Thomson, F. G. Physical methods in the treatment of heart disease. Lancet, Lond., 1933, 1: 196-8. ------ Discussion on the value of physical methods in the treatment of heart disease. Proc R. Soc. M., Lond., 1933, 26: 539-42— Vermel, S. B. [Physical methods of treating heart disease] Klin, med., Moskva, 1926, 4: 204-8. ---- Treatment: Principles. Battro, A. Tratamiento de los factores etio!6gicos de las cardiopatias. In Bibl. ter. Ter. clfn. (Cardini, C, & Bereter- vide, J. J.) B. Air., 1941, 1: 352-87.—Boeri, G. Considerazioni e norme per la terapia delle cardiopatie. Morgagni, 1934, 76: 4-8.—Cate, W. R. Common errors in the management of the cardiac patient. J. Tennessee M. Ass., 1938, 31: 216-21.— Chavez, I. El medico frente a sus enfermos cardfacos. Labor med., Mex., 1940, 8: 112-7. Also Rev. med., Puebla, 1941, 14: No. 127, 14-26. ------ La actitud del medico frente a sus enfermos cardiacos; ideas generales sobre el tratamiento. Arch. lat. amer. card., Mex., 1940, 10: 61-82. Also Ciencia, Mex., 1940, 1: 97-106. Also Gac. med. Mexico, 1940, 70: 553-72. Also Reforma med., Lima, 1940, 26: 447-56.—Dry, T. J. A rationale for the management of heart disease. J. Iowa M. Soc, 1939, 29: 236-40.—East.T. Some points in the treatment of cardiac disorders. Med. J. Australia, 1933, 2: 577-9.— Eggleston, C. Treatment of the elderly cardiac. Proc. Interst. Postgrad. M. Ass. N. America, 1936, 353-7.—Elliott, C. A. Factors frequently overlooked in the management of patients with heart disease. Ibid., 132-4.—Herrick, J. B. Comments on the treatment of heart disease. J. Am. M. Ass., 1928, 91: 1761-3. ------Carter, E. P. [et al.] Comments on the treat- ment of heart disease. Tr. Congr. Am. Physicians, 1928, 14: 76-90.—Karcher, J. Enttauschungen und Misserfolge bei der bausarztlichen Behandlung der Herzkranken. Schweiz. med. Wschr., 1934, 64: 345, 369.—Knighton, J. E., jr. Problems in cardiology. Tristate M. J., 1939-40, 12: 2398.—Liebstein, A. M. The rational treatment of diseases of the heart. Nat. Eclect. M. Ass. Q., 1938-39, 30: 27-32.—M., L. Quelques reflexions sur le traitement des cardiaques. Arch. med. beiges, 1941, 94: 156.—Netousek, M., Carsky, K., & Hensel, J. [New tendencies in treatment of heart diseases] Bratisl. lek. listy, 1937, 17: 49-64.—Primak, F. I. [Significance of the lymphatic system in the treatment of heart diseases] Ter. arkh., 1939, 17: No. 6, 16-22.—Renwick, W. J. Some observa- tions on the treatment of the more common forms of heart disease. Maine M. J., 1934, 25: 222-6.—Schoonmaker, H. Concerning the treatment of heart disease. Clifton M. Bull., 1929, 15: 29-35.—Smith, F. M. The discussion of certain features of cardiac therapy. J. Iowa M. Soc, 1931, 21: 287- 91.—Stein. L. Moderne Herztherapie. Wien. med. Wschr., 1933, 83: 373-5.—Stiegele, A. Einige Gesichtspunkte bei der homoopathischen Behandlung der Herzkrankheiten. In Nauheim. Fortbild. Lehrg., 1936, 12: 119-29.—Swan, W. G. A. Some points in the treatment of heart disease in practice. Newcastle M. J., 1940, 20: 59-64.—Usseglio, G. In margine alia grande terapia cardiaca. Gazz. med. ital., 1937, 96: 253- 65.—Varney, J. D. Better prescribing in heart cases. J. Am. Inst. Homeop., 1939, 32: 325-8.—Volhard, F. Consideraciones sobre las afecciones cardlacas y su tratamiento. Dia med., B. Air., 1940, 12: 41, 71.—Wenckebach, K. F. Das Entlastungs- prinzip in der Behandlung schwerster Herzfalle. Aerztl. Prax., Wien, 1938, 12: 121-3. Also Wien. klin. Wschr., 1937, 50: 1315-7.—White, P. D. Fallacies in the treatment of heart disease. N. Orleans M. & S. J., 1940-41, 93: 565-9.—Willius, F. A. Cardiac clinics, a talk on the appraisal of therapeutic effort. Proc. Mayo Clin., 1938, 13: 399. ------ A talk on the importance of the individualization of regimen for patients with heart disease. Ibid., 1940, 15: 52. ------ Cardiac clinics, a talk on the science and the art of medical practice. Ibid., 648-50.—Wybaux, R. Les grandes lignes du traitement des maladies du cceur. Ann. Soc. sc. med. natur. Bruxelles, 1Q34 bull 171-93. Also Bruxelles med., 1934-35, 15: 400. ---- Urine. Beilinsson, N. *Die Beziehungen zwischen Herzkrankheiten und Harnfarbstoffen [Jena] 27p. 8! Dohna i. Sa. [1930] Adlercreutz, E. [Urobilinuria after ingestion of fluids and physical exercise in compensated heart disease] Fin. lak. sail. hand., 1930, 72: 974-1010.—Brems, A., & Nielsen, E. Unter- suchungen iiber die Kreatinin- und Harnstoffclearance der Nieren bei Herzkrankheiten. Acta med. scand., 1934, Suppl. 59, 569.—Ciboldi, D. II p„ urinario nei cardiopazienti. Gior. clin. med., 1940, 21: 213-8.—Edelman, M. H., Halpern, L., & Killian, J. A. Urobilinuria, its prognostic value in children with heart disease. Am. J. Dis. Child., 1930, 39: 711-28. Also repr.—Jervell, O., & Andrup, O. Untersuchungen iiber die Ausscheidung unvollstiindig oxydierter Stoffe im Harne normaler Personen und von Herzpatienten. Acta med. scand., 1935, 85: 585-96.—Perger, H. Ueber die Beziehungen zwischen Ammoniakzahl und pH im Harn von Herzkranken. Klin. Wschr., 1929, 8: 63.—Sturm, R. Herzgrosse und Herz- funktion; Beitrag zur Stufenphotometrie des Hams von Herzgesunden, Hypertonikern, Herzfehlerkranken und mus- kular Herzinsuffizienten. Deut. Arch. klin. Med., 1931, 170: 24-37.—Tcherny, A. M. [Contents of ammonia in the urine in heart diseases] Klin. J. Saratov., 1929, 8: 259-63. ---- Uropoietic system [including diuresis] Claussen, F. Ueber die Diurese der Herzkranken. Erg. inn. Med. Kinderh., 1932, 43: 764-839.—Donath, F. Ueber den Einfluss der Diuresearbeit auf das geschadigte Herz. Wien. klin. Wschr., 1932, 45: 427-30.—Etienne, G., Verain, M., & Gerbaut, P. L'hyperfonctionnement renal dans les cardio- pathies compensees. Arch. mal. coeur, 1926, 19: 577-88.— Langeron, L., Paget, M., & Fruchart, G. Le fonctionnement du rein chez les cardiaques. Presse med., 1936, 44: 1289.— Laubry, C., Vericourt, E. R. de, & Porge, J. F. La diurese des cardiaques. Presse therm, clim., 1939, 80: 481.—Macrez, C. Hypnotiques et diurese chez les cardiaques. Gaz. med. France, 1938, 45: 193-6.—Peters, J. T. [Cardiac patients with con- tinued excessive diuresis in spite of no loss of weightl Geneesk. gids, 1936, 14: 97-109.—Stewart, H. J., & Mcintosh, J. F. The function of the kidneys in patients suffering from chronic cardiac disease without signs of heart failure. J. Clin. Invest., 1928, 6: 325-45. ---- in animals. Barke, A. Die Alkalireserve bei herzkranken Hunden. Munch, tierarztl. Wschr., 1938, 89: 225-8.—Batt, H. T. Three cases of heart disease in horses. Cornell Vet., 1941, 31: 70-6.— Cloete, J. H. L., & Steyn, H. P. Anatomical studies No. 63: an abnormal bovine heart. Onderstepoort J. Vet. Sc, 1940, 14: 481-8.—Frede, W. Toxische Herzerkrankung bei Schweinen. Deut. tierarztl. Wschr., 1926, 34: 658.—Fritzsche. Die Erkrankungen des Herzens und der Atmungsorgane des Schweines im Lichte neuer Forschungsergebnisse. Jahrber. Schles. Ges. vaterl. Kult. (1935) 1936, 108: 25-7.—Leblois, C. Note sur une remarquable lesion cardiaque. Bull. Acad. vet. France, 1929, 2: 227-31.—Loewe, L., & Lanke, S. E. Cardiac lesions resembling Aschoff bodies in rabbits. J. Exp. M„ 1940, 71: 89-94, 3 pl.—McCunn, J. Remarks on heart disease in the horse. Vet. Rec, Lond., 1934, 14: 779792—Nyboer, J. Non-induced cardiopathic disease in a rabbit; electrocardio- graphic and pathologic study. Proc. Soc. Exp. Biol., N. Y., 1940, 44: 435-9.—Pillers, A. W. N. The post-mortem examina- tion of the horse's heart. Vet. Rec, Lond., 1934, 14: 913.— Rainard. Alterations pathologiques du cceur sur une vache. J. med. vet., Lyon, 1849, 5: 425-32.—Steffan, H. Das Herz bei inneren Erkrankungen des Pferdes; I. Elektro- und phono- kardiographische Untersuchungen. Arch. wiss. prakt. Tierh., 1934 68: 159-82.—Taylor, H. Some diseases of the heart. Vet, Rec, Lond., 1937, 17: 1559-63.—Wilens, S. L., & Sproul, E E. Spontaneous cardiovascular disease in the rat; lesions of the heart. Am. J. Path., 1938, 14: 177-99, 3 pl. ---- in the pregnant. See also under Heart failure. Bramwell, C, & Longson, E. A. Heart disease and pregnancy. 194p. 8? Lond., 1938. HEART DISEASE 286 HEART DISEASE Chemnitzer, N. *Considerations sur les cardiopathies de la premiere moitie de la gesta- tion. 55p. 8? Strasb., 1935. -Di: Sio-Cesari, E. Cardiopatie e gravidanza. 243p. 8? Nap., 1915. Frey, W. Herz und Schwangerschaft. 124p. 8? Lpz., 1923. Hamilton, B. E., & Thomson, K. J. The heart in pregnancv and the childbearing age. 402p. 24cm. Bost., 1941. Jagics N. Herzkrankheiten bei Frauen. 103p. 8? Berl., 1926. Jensen, J. The heart in pregnancy. 371p. 8? S. Louis, 1938. Meinhardt, A. *Die Einwirkungen von Schwangerschaft, Geburt und Wochenbett auf Herzkranke [Berlin] 47p. 8? Stettin, 1934. Meyer-Steineg, E. *Herzerkrankungen und Schwangerschaft [Jena] 40p. 8! [Zeulenroda] 1925. Abraham, J. [Pregnancy and heart disease] Orvoskepzes, 1936, 26: sept, kulonf. (T6th Festschr.) 114-20.—Allan, M. Heart disease in pregnancy. Brit. M. J., 1935, 2: 801.— Anderodias. Cardiopathies et grossesse. Progr. med., Par., 1937, 1145.—Arrillaga, F. C. Cardiopatias y embarazo. Arch. urug. med., 1040, 16: 1-15.—Basu, M. N. Heart disease in pregnancy. Calcutta M. J., 1939, 36: 30-7.—Bazan, J. Las cardiopatias y el embarazo. Dia med., B. Air., 1932-33, 5: 879-82. ------ El problema de la gravida cardiaca. Sem. med.. B. Air., 1934. 41: 4-8.—Bertrand, A. Deux cas de cardio- pathy au coins de la grossesse. Union med. Canada, 1934, 63: 438—11.—Blumenfeld, I. B. Heart disease and pregnancy. Med. Hec, N. V., 1938, 147: 248-51.—Borg, J. F. Heart dis- ease in pregnancy. Minnesota M., 1939, 22: 24-8.—Brambilla, A., & Colombi. ('. la portata cardiaca della gestante. Ann. ostet. gin.. 193-1, 56: 311-40.—Bramwell, C. Heart disease complicating pregnancy. Proc. R. Soc. M., Lond., 1931, 24: 709-23.—Braun, G. Herz und Schwangerschaft. Allg. Deut. Hebam. Ztg, 1927, 42: 115-7.—Brown, J. W. Heart disease and pregnancy. J. R. Inst. Pub. Health, 1937-38, 1: 806-10.- Cairns, R. O. Heart disease in pregnancy. Tr. R. Med. Chir. Soc. Glasgow, 1938, 32: 79.—Calandre, L., & Luque, F. Los problemas del embarazo en las enfermas del coraz6n. Progr. clin., Madr., 1927, 35: 590-4.—Cameron, J. C. Heart disease and pregnancy. Am. J. Obst., 1908, 58: 422-46.— Carr, F. B. Heart disease in pregnancy. N. England J. M., 1938, 219: 231. Also Med. Ann. District of Columbia, 1941, 10: 16-20.------& Palmer, R. S. Observations on electro- cardiography in heart disease associated with pregnancy with especial reference to axis deviation. Am. Heart J., 1932, 8: 238-41.—Carreras, F., & Cortes, C. Cardiopatias y embarazo. Rev. med. Barcelona, 1929, 12: 508-18.—Consoli, D. Note cliniche sulle cardiopatie complicanti lo stato puerperale. Clin, ostet., 1937, 39: 249-57.—Cuizza, T. Sulle cardiopatie in gravidanza. Monit. ostet. gin., 1934,6: 66-86, ch.—Daichman, I., & Kornfeld, G. Pregnancy complicating cardiac disease Am. J. Obst., 1935, 30: 386-91.—Daniels, W. B. Pregnancy in heart disease. Med. Ann. District of Columbia, 1933, 2: 282-90.—De Maria, G. La riserva alcalina nelle cardiopatiche gravide. Clin, ostet., 1933, 35: 645-56.—DePuy, C. A. Heart disease complicating pregnancy. California West. M., 1935, 43: 355-8.—Donovan, H. C. E. Heart disease complicating pregnancy. Brit. M. J., 1936, 1: 104.—Easby, M. H. A case of congenital heart disease complicated by pregnancy. Med. Woman J., 1934, 41: 309-11.—Eastman, N. J. Heart disease in pregnancy. Internat. Clin., Phila., 1933, 43. ser., 2: 238- 64.—Espina. Cardiopatfas y embarazo. Actas Congr. espafi. obst. gin. pediat., 1911, 2. Congr., 375-85.—Fellner, O. O. Herzkrankheiten und Schwangerschaft. Wien. klin. Wschr., 1928, 41: 960.—FitzGibbon, G. Cardiac disease in pregnancy and labour. Brit. M. J., 1927, 2: 253-5 — Flaxman, N. Preg- nancy and heart disease. Am. J. Obst., 1940, 39: 814-7.— Frigyesi, J. [Heart disease and pregnancy] Orv. hetil., 1931, 75: 1139.—Gammeltoft, S. A. Practical aspects of the associa- tion of heart disease with pregnancv. Proc. Interst. Postgrad. M. Ass. N. America, (1927) 1928, 3: 60-6, portr.—Gelle. Grossesse et cardiopathies. Echo med. nord, 1933, 37: 193- 8.—Gilchrist, A. R. Heart disease in relation to pregnancy Tr. Edinburgh Obst. Soc, 1930-31, Sess. 90, 121-35.—Gilia- revsky, S. A., Nikonova, V. I., & Greibo, A. D. [Heart diseases and pregnancy] Ter. arkh., Moskva, 1934, 12: 124-32.— Gordon, C. A., Quigley, J. A., & Schoeneck, F. J. Heart dis- ease in rieL'nancy. N. York State J. M., 1941. 41: 1105.— Hagedorn. W. Ueber Herzkrankheiten wahrend der Gesta- tionsperiode. Munch, med. Wschr., 1937, 84: 1246-9.— Halban, J. Herzkrankheiten und Schwangerschaft Wien klin. Wschr., 1928, 41: 961. ------ Enfermedades dei coraz6n y embarazo. Rev. med. germ. iber. amer., 1930, 3: 193-202.—Hamilton, B. E. Heart disease in the pregnant woman. Am. J. Surg., 1937, 35: 284-92. ------ Cardiac disease in pregnancy. Mod. Concepts Card. Dis., 1938, 7: No. 10, 1. ------ & Kellogg, F. S. Observations on heart disease complicating pregnancy. Am. J. Obst., 1927, 13: 535- 40. Harris, K. Heart disease with normal rhythm com- plicating pregnancy. Lancet, Lord., 1937, 1: 677-81.—Hay, J. The disabled heart and pregnancy. Postgrad. M. J., Lond., 1036, 12: 143-54.—Heart disease with pregnancy. N. England ,1. M., 1036, 214: 545- Hepburn, J. Cardiac disease associated with pregnancy. Bull. Acad. M. Toronto, 1037, II: 7-10. - Herrmann, G., & King, E. L. Cardiovascular disturbances in the obstetric patient; with special reference to electrocardio- graphic observations. J. Am. M. Ass., 1930, 95: 1472-7.— Hone, F. S. Heart disease and pregnancy. Med. J. Australia, 1930, 1: 2-6.—Hunt, G. H. Heart disease and pregnancv. Guy's Hosp. Rep., Lond., 1926, 76: 135-44.—Ide, M. (Im,. sesse et affections cardiqaues. Rev. med., Louvain, 1929, 329 31.—Indenbaum, S. S. [Clinical aspect of organic defects of the heart during pregnancy] Akush. gin., 1938, No. 11, 6-17.— Jaschke, von. Herzkrankheiten und Gestation. Arch. Gyn., Berl., 1938, 166: 24^3.—Jensen, J. Heart disease and pregnancy. J. Am. M. Ass., 1936, 107: 329-31. Also Handel. Internat. congr. verlosk., 1938, 2: 279-83. Also J. Missouri M. Ass., 1939, 36: 112.—Johnstone, B. I. Heart disease and pregnancy. J. Michigan M. Soc, 1933, 32: 479-85.—Keller, R., & Fauve, R. Cardiopathies et grossesse. Bull. Soc. gyn. obst. Paris, 1939, 28: 496.—Kerr, J. M. M. Discussion on the relation of pregnancy to general diseases; cardiac disease. Brit. M. J., 1927, 2: 245-7.—Klein, P. Ueber das Cor kypho- skolioticum in der Gestation. Arch. Gyn., Berl., 1927, 130: 653; 132: [Discussion] 334-6.—Laffont & Fulconis. Cardio- pathie et grossesse. Bull. Soc. obst. gyn. Paris, 1934, 23: 501- 3.—Lamb, A. E. Heart disease in pregnancy; a preliminary report. Am. J. M. Sc, 1934, 187: 177-84.—Langley, R. W. Chronic heart disease complicating pregnancy. California West. M., 1927, 27: 193-5.—Lurie, A. U. [Importance of correct diagnosis of heart diseases in pregnancy] J. akush., 1929, 40: 262-76.—McClure, H. I. Pregnancy complicated by heart disease. J. Obst. Gyn. Brit. Empire, 1932, 39: 357-61. Also Ulster M. J., 1936, 5: 234-40.—Martin Rodriguez, F. Cardiopatia y embarazo. An. Hosp. S. Jose, Madr., 1933-34, 5: 223-6.—May, E. Cardiopathies et grossesse. Rev. crit. path., Par., 1932-33, 3: 799-810.—Murray, L. M. Heart disease in pregnancy. Canad. M. Ass. J., 1930, 23: 535.— Newman, M. Heart disease and pregnancy. Practitioner, Lond., 1931, 126: 644-51.—Neyolov, N. K. [Cardiac disease in pregnancy] J. akush., 1909, 23: 807-12.—Oliver, T. Heart disease and pregnancy. Brit. M. J., 1927, 1: 709-11. Also Med. Brief, 1927, 55: 287-93.—Parade, G. W. Kreislauf, Herzkrankheiten und Schwangerschaft. Med. Klin., Berl., 1936, 32: 1436-9.—Pardee, H. E. B. Heart disease and preg- nancy. Mod. Concepts Card. Dis., 1932, 1: 1.—Peham, H. Herz und Schwangerschaft. Wien. med. Wschr., 1930, 80: 083.—Pithon, A. Cardiopathies et grossesse. Progr. med., Par., 1933, 1997-2004.—Podolsky, E. The heart in pregnancy. Med. Rec, N. Y., 1934, 139: 180-3.—Pumphrey, A. B. The heart in pregnancy. Texas J. M., 1939-40, 35: 829-32 — Richter, I. M., & Rickard, J. F. Pregnancy as a complication of heart disease. California West. M., 1933, 39: 306-9 — Rivi6re. Cardiopathie et grossesse. Gaz. sc. med. Bordeaux, 1911,345.—Roos, L. Le cardiopatie e gravidanza. Ann. ostet. gin., 1936, 58: Suppl., 913-54, ch.—Rowland, J. M. H. Heart disease complicated by pregnancy. Virginia M. Month., 1935- 36, 62: 685-91.—Sage, E. C. Heart disease and pregnancy. Nebraska M. J., 1942, 27: 24.—Schultze, M. A study of cardiac disease complicating pregnancy. Tr. Pacific Soc. Obst. Gyn., 1935, 5: 109-16. Also West. J. Surg., 1936, 44: 80-7 — Schuman, W. Heart disease complicating pregnancy; a clinical study. Am. J. Obst., 1935, 29: 64-70.—Siedentopf, H. Die herzkranke Schwangere. Med. Klin., Berl., 1938, 34: 1058- 60.—Sims, T. J. Heart disease complicating pregnancy. Kansas City M. J., 1941, 17: No. 4, 22-5.—Sodeman, W. A. Cardiac changes in pregnancy unrelated to the usual etiologic types of heart disease. Am. Heart J., 1939, 18: [Discussion] 598-600; 1940, 19: 385— Sothoron, E. Three cases of cardiac lesion complicating pregnancy and labor. Am. J. Obst., 1910, 62:272-5 [Discussion] 304-6.—Stander, H. J. Cardiac disease in pregnancy. Ibid., 1934, 27: 528-36.—Stray horn, W. D. Heart disease and pregnancy. J. Tennessee M. Ass., 1935, 28: 492-8.—Stroud, W. D., & Bromer, A. W. Pregnancy and heart disease. In Cyclop. Med. (Piersol-Bortz) Phila., Serv. Vol., 1941, 227-9.—Sutton, D. C, & Engbring, G. Heart disease and pregnancy. Illinois M, J., 1937, 72: 147-53.—Theisen, R.I. Heart disease in pregnancy. J. Iowa M. Soc, 1935, 25: 648-51.—Thomson, K. J., Cohen, M. E., & Hamilton, B. E. Studies on the circulation in pregnancy; lead 5 of the electro- cardiogram in pregnancy, including normal, cardiac and toxemic women. Am. J. M. Sc, 1938, 196: 819-24, 3 pl.—Trias de Bes, L. Observaciones sobre la evoluci6n de las cardiopatfas en el embarazo. Arch, med., Madr., 1928, 28: 650-4.—Vergo, W. A. Pregnancy and heart disease. Med. J. Australia, 1930, 1: 6. Wagner, G. A. Herz und Frauenkrankheiten, Herz und Gestation. Zschr. arztl. Fortbild., 1931, 28: 545; 581 — White, S. M. The heart in pregnancy. J. Lancet, 1932, 52: 655-8.—Young, C. Heart disease and pregnancy. Canad. M. Ass. J., 1931, 25: 154-8.—Zarday, I. [Pregnancy in cardiac patients] Orvoskepzes, 1938, 28: 509-22. ---- in the pregnant: Complications. Leproux, P. *Sur 2 cas d'ocdeme aigu du poumon chez des cardiaques enceintes et hospitali- HEART DISEASE 287 HEART DISEASE sees ?au cours de leur gestation. 54p. 8? Lyon, 1935'. Pupunat, J. *Huit observations d'accidents gravido-cardiaques. 67p. 25crn. Lyon, 1939. Wateau, A. *Sur la nature inflammatoire des accidents gravido-cardiaques. 77p. 8? Lyon, 1909. Achard, C. Accidents gravido-cardiaques. Rev. gen. clin. ther., 1933, 47: 97-103.—Bazan, J. Muerte por el coraz6n, durante el embarazo, parto y puerperio. Sem. med., B. Air., 1928, 35: 1262-7.—Bickel, G. Le role de la carence en vitamine Bi dans la pathogenie des cardiopathies gravidiques. Rev. med. Suisse rom., 1940, 60: 440-5.—Chamorro, Folco & Dacharry. Accidentes grdvidocardfacos en una primeriza de 21 anos de edad. Sem. med., B. Air., 1922, 29: 577-80.— De Lauretis, G. Con quale meccanismo la gravidanza aggrava le malattie di cuore. Monit. ostet. gin., 1932, 4: 395-427.— Fornero, A. L'influenza ripetuta e diretta dello stato gravidico su cuori malati, gik ai primi albori del concepimento, e ricerche su cuori sard. Ibid., 1931, 3: 85-98.—Fruhinsholz. Accidents gravido-cardio-renaux. Bull. Soc. obst. gyn. Paris, 1935, 24: 181-4. ------ & Beigbeder. Nouvelles precisions sur les accidents gravido-cardiaques des cardio-renales. Ibid., 1937, 26: 421-4.—Hartemann, J. A propos de la pathogenie des accidents gravido-cardiaques. Gyn. obst., Par., 1927, 16: 30-42.—Jensen, F. G. Investigations on the influence of pregnancy and parturition upon organic cardiac disease. Acta obst. gyn. scand., 1927, 6: 239-78.—Kreis, J. Cardiopathies (gravidotoxiques) graves dans la premiere moitie de la grossesse. Bull. Soc. obst. gyn. Paris, 1926, 15: 524-6.—Naish, F. C. A study of the immediate and remote effects of pregnancy on diseases of the heart. J. Obst. Gyn. Brit. Empire, 1937, 44: 659-86.—Sheehan, H. L., & Sutherland, A. M. The pathology of heart disease in pregnancy. Ibid., 1940, 47: 597-668.— Teel, H. M. A study of the fetal mortality in patients with organic heart disease. Am. J. Obst., 1935, 30: 53-61.— Williams, P. F. Heart disease and pregnancy; maternal deaths from cardiac disease. Delaware M. J., 1937, 9: 207-14. ---- in the pregnant: Indication of abortion. See also Abortion, justifiable. Luchesi, J. *Herz und Schwangerschaft; Untersuchungen iiber das spatere Schicksal herzkranker Frauen nach kunstlicher Unter- brechung der Schwangerschaft [Berlin] 51p. 23y2cm. Charlottenb., 1938. Mouton, C. indications de l'evacuation uterine dans les accidents gravido-cardiaques. 67p. 8? Par., 1926. Rouchy, R. P. *L'interruption therapeutique de la gestation dans les cardiopathies; indications techniques. 109p. 8? Par., 1938. Balatd, Broustet & Mahon. L'interruption de la grossesse dans les cas de cardiopathie; indications et techniques. Gyn. obst., Par., 1939, 39: 466; 40: [Discussion] 142.—Fruhinsholz & Hartemann. A propos de 1'interruption de la grossesse dans les cardiopathies. Bull. Soc. gyn. obst. Paris, 1938, 27: 714- 7.—Garcia Pintos, S. La interrupcion del embarazo en las cardiopatias. Dia med. urug., 1934, 1: 141-3.—Gernez, L. De l'avortement therapeutique chez une cardiaque, pratique par voie abdominale sous anesthesie locale. Bull. Soc. gyn. obst. Paris, 1939, 28: 189-91.—Hansen, O. S. The attitude of the internist concerning the damaged heart in pregnancy. J. Lancet, 1938, 58: 278-80.—Lantuejoul & Merger. Cardio- pathie et grossesse; les indications de ['intervention chirurgicale. Bull. Soc. gyn. obst. Paris, 1938, 27: 657-9. Also Gyn. obst., Par., 1938, 38: 401-8.—Offergeld, H. Die Berechnung der Herzleistung vor und fiir die Geburt (ein Beitrag zur Unter- brechung der Schwangerschaft bei Herzkrankheiten) Arch. Gyn., Berl., 1931, 146: 533-65.—Pardee, H. E. B. Cardiac conditions indicating therapeutic abortion. J. Am. M. Ass., 1934, 103: 1899-902.—Pasteur Vallery-Radot, Portes & Rouchy. Accidents gravido-cardiaques; interruption de la gestation au cours du 5° mois par hysterotomie abdominale sous anesthesie localisee; sterilisation par section des trompes. Bull. Soc. gyn. obst. Paris, 1938, 27: 351-4.—Rouchy, R. La legitimite de 1'interruption de la grossesse dans les cardio- pathies. Arch. med. Angers, 1938, 42: 205-12.—Routier, D., Laennec, T., & Heim de Balsac, R. Les dangers de l'avortement therapeutique chez les cardiaques. Gaz. hop., 1931, 104: 1965— Scipiades, E. Herzkrankheit und kunstlicher Abort. Arch. Gyn., Berl., 1938, 166: 65-7 [Discussion[ 81-8.—Sosa Marti- nez, P. De la interrupci6n del embarazo en las cardlacas. Rev. med. Yucaten, 1932-33, 17: 25. ---- in the pregnant: Management. Bramwell, C. Treatment of heart disease in pregnancy. Brit. M. J., 1935, 1: 1132. Also In Treat. Gen. Pract., 2. ed., Lond., 1938, 1: 194-200.—Burwell, C. S. The effect of preg- nancy on the management of heart disease; abstract. BuU. Richmond Acad. M., 1940, 8: 117.—Carreras, F., & Cortes, C. Cardiopathies et grossesse. Bull. Soc. obst. gyn. Paris, 1930, 19: 35-43.—Cornel E. L. The management of heart cases i£nP™?,nancy and labor> Surg- Clin- N- America, 1927 7- b89-700— Courtois, J. Coeur et grossesse; conduite a tenir dans les cardiopathies. Rev. gen. clin. ther., 1937 51- 529- 5*?i! 5.65-—F'.fcgerald, J. E. Management of pregnant women with heart disease. Proc. Inst. M. Chicago, 1934, 10- 140 Also Am. J. Obst., 1935, 29: 53-63.—Garcfa-Pintos, S. E\ problema de la cardiopatia y el estado puerperal. Arch urug med., 1934, 5: 158-84.—Hamilton, B. E. The care of a cardiac patient during pregnancy. Am J. Nurs., 1927, 27: 173-7.__ Jensen, J. The management of heart disease in pregnancy South. M. J., 1936, 29: 572-4.-King, H. C. Prognosis and management of heart disease and pregnancy. Ohio M J 1939, 35: 497-501.—Kloman, E. H. A report of a case of pregnancy complicated by heart and kidney disease, with special reference to the treatment of severe cases. Maryland M. J., 1911 54: 227-32.—Lenczowski, J. [Methods in the treatment of diseases of the heart in pregnancy and puerperal period] Polska gaz. lek., 1929, 8: 948-51.—Lundy, C. J., Bauer, C. P. [et al.] Management of heart disease in pregnancv Proc. Inst. M. Chicago, 1937, 11: 326.—Marchetti, A. A. The management of heart disease in pregnancy. Med. Clin N America, 1935, 19: 893-9.—Nelson, G. The cardio-vascular- renal complications of pregnancy and their managem. nt South. M. & S., 1928, 90: 238-48.—Pardee, H. E. B. Ex- periences in the management of pregnancy complicated by heart disease. Am. J. Obst., 1929, 17: 255-62.—Peralta Ramos, A., & Bazan, J. Observaciones de algun interes prdctico en el dominio de las cardiopatias y estado puerperal. Bol Acad. nac. med. B. Aires, 1935, 52-60. Also Prensa med argent., 1935, 22: 1179-82.—Podolsky, E. The management of the heart in pregnancy. Virginia M. Month., 1938, 65: 686-90.—Smith, D. L. Heart disease complicating pregnancy; diagnosis and treatment. J. Indiana M. Ass., 1934, 27: 254^9.—Soulie, P. Considerations pratiques et therapeu- tiques sur les accidents gravido-cardiaques. Progr. med , Par., 1938, pt 2, 1354.—Stander, H. J., & Kuder, K. The treatment of heart disease complicating pregnancy. J. Am M. Ass., 1937, 108: 2092-6.—Wells, G. W. Treatment of heart disease in pregnancy. In Med. Papers (H. A. Christian Anniv. Vol.) Bost., 1936, 122-4.— Zagalskaia, A. G. [Applica- tion of the Narzan spring baths in cardiac diseases during pregnancy] Akush. gin., 1941, No. 6, 41. ---- in the pregnant: Obstetrical aspect. Eichhorn, M. *Schwangerschaft und Geburt bei herzkranken Frauen [Heidelberg] 31 p. 21cm. Gutersloh [1935] Veyre, P. *Renseignement fournis par 1'electrocardiographic chez la femme enceinte cardiaque et chez la femme enceinte normale au cours de la grossesse et au cours du travail [Lyon] 35p. 8? Vienne, 1936. Abramovits, A. Pregnancy and delivery in women with heart disease. Harefuah, Tel Aviv, 1941, 20: 83; 21: 4.— Dawson, J. B. Heart disease in pregnancy; the obstetrical standpoint. N. Zealand M. J., 1940, 39: N. Zealand Obst. Gyn. Soc, 6-10.—Eastman, N. J. Heart disease in pregnancy; the respective duties of internist and obstetrician. Med. Clin. N. America, 1937, 21: 1407-16.—Gelle. Cesarienne pour accidents gravido-cardiaques. Bull. Soc. gvn. obst. Paris, 1938, 27: 523-5.—Irving, F. C. Delivery and obstetrical after- care of cardiacs. In Heart in pregnancv (Hamilton, B. E., & Thomson, K. J.) Bost., 1941, 100-12.—Nelson, H. B., & Eades, M. F. Some obstetrical aspects of cardiac disease complicated by pregnancy. N. England J. M., 1935, 213: 1057-61 — Rudolph, L. The importance of the posture of the cardiopath during pregnancy and labor. Am. J. Obst., 1932, 23: 546-50.— Sachs, E. Ueber die Geburtsleitung bei herzkranken Frauen. Deut. med. Wschr., 1928, 54: 45-7.—Stieglitz, E. J. Cardiac disease in obstetrics. Am. J. Surg., 1940, 48: 36-46.—Turino, T. R., & Antony, A. T. Heart disease in pregnancy; obstetrical aspects. Ibid., 1938, 41: 453-7.—Ujma, A. Ueber Schwanger- schaft und Geburt bei herzkranken Frauen. Zbl. Gyn., 1929, 53: 2967-71. ---- in the pregnant: Prognosis. Kruttke, H. G. *Das Schicksal herzkranker Frauen wahrend und nach der Schwangerschaft, mit Nachuntersuchungen [Berlin] 66p. 23}£cm. Halle, 1938. Bazan, J. La cardi6pata frente al problema de la materni- dad. Sem. med., B. Air., 1938, 45: 539-41.—Bramwell, C. Prognosis of heart disease in pregnancy. Lancet, Lond., 1935, 1: 629.—Burwell, C. S. The influence of pregnancy on the course of heart disease. South. M. J., 1936, 29: 1194-7.— Bustos Moron, R. Las cardiopatias en sus relaciones con el estado puerperal; consideraciones sobre su pron6stico. Prensa med. argent., 1928-29, 15: 1381-96.—Consoli, D. Per la prognosi delle cardiopatie in rapporto alio stato puerperale. Clin, ostet., 1928, 30: 846-52.—Hamlton, B. E., & Kellogg, F. S. Cardiac disease in pregnancy, prognosis; medical and obstetric handling. J. Am. M. Ass., 1928, 91: 1942-4.— HEART DISEASE SS HEART FAILURE Pigeaud, H. Cardiopathies et grossesse; elements de pronostic tires de l'examen des femmes enceintes au cours de la gestation. J. med. chir., Par.. 1933, 104: 628-35.—Reid, W. D. The prognosis of heart disease in pregnancy. Am. J. Obst., 1930, 19: 63-71.—Vitali, M. II significato ed il valore delle prove urologiche nella valutazione della funzionalitit del miocardio in tema di cardiopatia e gravidanza. Ann. ostet. gin., 1937, 59: 1155-68. ---- in the pregnant: Statistics. Cassan, P. Cardiopathies et gestation; statistique de la Maternite" de Lariboisiere. 62p. 8? Par., 1926. Carr, F. B., & Hamilton, B. E. Five hundred women with serious heart di.-eases followed through pregnancy and de- livery. Am. J. Obst., 1933, 26: 824-39.— Corwin, J., Herrick, W. W. [et al.] Pregnancy and heart disease; a statistical report and summary of 196 cases. Ibid., 1927, 13: 617-22.—Hamilton, B. E. Sixteen years' experience with heart disease in pregnant women. Am. Heart J., 1937, 14: 555-61.—Hanley, B. J., & Anderson, J. F. A review of 190 cases of heart disease com- plicating pregnancy. Am. J. Obst., 1935, 30: 243-8.—Hay, J., & Hunt, E. A record of 50 consecutive cases of pregnancy and parturition in patients with crippled hearts. Lancet, Lond., 1928, 1: 271-4.—Jensen, J., Wegner, C. [et al.] Heart disease and pregnancy; an 8 years' experience. Am. J. Obst., 1940, 39: 443-9.-—Lamb, A. E. Heart disease in pregnancy, an analysis of 110 cases. Ibid., 1937, 34: 456-69— Sferra, P. Rendiconto statistico sopra 36 casi di cardiopatia e gravidanza ricoverati nella Maternite nei biennio i937-1938. Ann. ostet. gin., 1939, 61: 1155-70.—Stander, H. J. Heart disease complicating pregnancv; a studv of 436 cases. Am. J. Obst., 1938, 36: 413-9.—Voron, Pigeaud & Magnin, P. Analyses de 24 observations ayant trait k des femmes hospitalisees pour accidents gravido-cardiaques au cours de leurs grossesses. Gyn. obst., Par., 1939, 40: 151-3. HEART failure. See also Cardiovascular system, Insufficiency; Heart auricle, Disease; Heart-block, Syncope; Heart muscle, Disease; Heart valves, Disease; Heart ventricle, Failure. Arrillaga, F. C. Insuficiencia cardfaca. 304p. 8? B. Air., 1929. Fishberg, A. M. Heart failure. 788p. 8? Phila., 1937. Also 2. ed. 829p. 1940. Walzer, F. Cardiac weakness; causes, symp- toms, cure. 94p. 8? Hanover [1934] Alexandrescu, N., & Finkelstein, A. [On cardiac insuffi- ciency] Rev. st. med., Bucur., 1025, i4: 563-6.—Arroyo Naranjo, M. Insuficiencias cardfacas v asistolias irreductibles. Arch. Fac. cienc. med., Quito, 1933, 2: 5-9.—Beco, H. L. de. L'insuffisance cardiaque. Cas. lek. Cesk.. 1037, 76: 681-4.— Brams, W. A. Heart failure. Med. Clin. X. America. 1929-30, 13: 1187-94.—Bramwell, C. Heart failure. In Brit. Encvcl. M. Pract. (Rolleston, H.) Lond., 1937, 6: 368-83.—Ceconi, A. L'insufficenza di cuore. Minerva med., Tor., 1926, 6:471-83.— Chavez, I. Insuficiencia cardfaca. Rev. med. Veracruz., 1940, 20: 3246-50.—Cowan, J. The failing heart. Edinburgh M. J., 1926, n. ser., 33: 465; 533, 2 pl.—Davis, J. W. The heart. South. M. & S., 1934, 96: 222.—Devitt, J. S. Heart failure; causes, diagnosis and treatment. Marquette M. Rev., 1939-40, 4: 47-50.—Drouet, G. Asystolie. J. med. Paris, 1926, 45: 868-73.—Ellis, R. Cardiac failure. Liverpool Med. Chir. J., 1938-39, 46: 133-9. Also Clin. J., Lond., 1940, 69: 124-7.—Eltze, M. Ueber Herzinsuffizienz. Deut. med. Wschr., 1939, 65: 722-6.—Elwell, E. G. Cardiac failure. Med. Press & Circ, Lond., 1936, 193: 151-4.—Girard, J. Insuffisance cardiaque. Gaz. hop., Par., 1927, 100: 669-78.— Goyena, J. R. Sobre insuficiencia cardiaca y asistolia. Dfa med., B. Air., 1033-34, 6: 149.—Guggenheimer, H. Herzin- suffizienz. Deut. med. Wschr., 1929, 55: 705.—Hay, J. Car- diac failure. Liverpool Med. Chir. J., 1938-39, 46: 155-68.— Lambert, G. Cardiac failure. Clin. J., Lond., 1938, 67: 186-97.—Laughlin, C. B. The failing heart. J. Tennessee M. Ass., 1935, 28: 361-4.—Lian, C. De l'insuffisance cardi- aque. Presse med., 1926, 34: 721-4.—Merklen, P. Insuf- fisance cardiaque. Strasbourg med., 1930, 90: 125.—Parsons- Smith, B. Cardiac failure. Lancet, Lond., 1936, 2: 1503-7.— Shuman, J..W. Cardiac failure. Med. J. & Rec, 1931, 134: 60-2.—Smith, K. S. Heart-failure. Lancet, Lond., 1939, ): 1168-70.—Towers, J. R. H. Cardiac failure. Practitioner Lond., 1941, 147: 702-70— Lpham, J. H. J. Heart disease and heart failure. .1. M. A.-s. Georgia, 1037, 26: 485-9. Also Wisconsin M. J., 103,8. 37: 459-62.—Velasco Lombardini, R. La insuficiencia cardiaea. Arch. urug. med., 1934, 4: 394- 404.—Ward, G. E. S. The failing heart. Clin. J., Lond. 1935 64: 269-77.—White, P. D. Heart failure. Bull. N. York Acad. M., 1942, 18: 18-35.—Wiggers, C. J. The heart that fails. Sc. Month., 1941, 52: 34-43.—Williams, C. A. The failing heart. J. Am. Inst. Homeop., 1939, 32: 539-45 ---- acute. See also Heart disease, Emergency. Arrillaga, F. Insuficiencia cardfaca paroxlstica. Dia rndd., H. Air., 1030, 11: 57-60.—Bonaba. J., & Said (in de Rodriguez, M. L. Asistolia aguda primitiva del lactante. An. Fac. med., Montev., 1038, 23: 453-530, 6 pl.—Bufalo, V. Insulficienza di cuore a rapido decorso. Rinasc. med., 1937, 14: 451.—Coelho, E. Colapso e insuficiencia cardfaca aguda. Lisboa med., 1929, 6: 328-32.—Coombs, C. F. The treatment of acute cardiac failure. Practitioner, Lond., 1933, 130: 245 -00.— Geraudel, E., & Gomez, D. M. Anomalies transitoires du mecanisme cardia- que chez une fillette de 10 ans, au cours d'une crise d'in- suffisance cardiaque; influence probable de l'ouabaine. Paris med., 1931, 79: 256-60.—Harrison, T. R., Friedman, B., & Resnik, H., jr. Mechanism of acute experimental heart failure. Arch. Int. M., 1936, 57: 927-48.— Henderson, J. G. Coramine in acute cardiac failure. Canad. M. Ass. J., 1933, 29: 70.— Holler, G. Was hat der Arzt bei akutem Versagen der Herz- kraft zu tun? Aerztl. Prax., Wien, 1930, 163.—Hyman, A. S. Sudden heart failure as a public health menace. Am. J. Pub. Health, 1929, 19: 1103-10.—Leech, C. B. Acute heart failure. N. England J. M., 1937, 217: 335-^2.—Levy, L. [Acute heart failure] Gy6gyaszat, 1936, 76: 758; 1937, 77: 4— McMahon, A. Emergency treatment of acute heart failure. J. Am. M. Ass., 1939, 113: 1025-9.—McMillan, R. D. Emergency treat- ment of acute heart failure in general practice. North Carolina M. J., 1940, 1: 668-73.—Mensi, E. Insufficienza cardiaca Wita infantile. Policlin. inf., Tor., 1939, 7: 98-101.—More- head, O. J. Vitamin Bi for acute heart failure; case of a 2H- year old girl. Northwest M., 1941, 40: 57.—Quattlebaum, J. T. Intravenous therapy in the treatment of acute heart failure and cardiac asthma. J. S. Carolina M. Ass., 1940, 36: 338- 44.—Reitter, C, & Leifer, P. Hohe Eupaverindosen bei plotzhchem Herztod. Wien. med. Wschr., 1940, 90: 392.— Saldun de Rodriguez, M. L. Nuevo caso de asistolia aguda primitiva en un lactante. Arch, argent, pediat., 1940, 13: 89. Also Arch, pediat: Uruguay, 1940, 11: 121-7.—Schmidt, F. [Acute heart failure] Gy6gyaszat, 1934, 74: 561.—Siedek, H. Klinik und Therapie der akuten Herzinsuffizienz. Wien. klin. Wschr., 1938, 51: 1286-9. Also Aerztl. Prax., Wien, 1939, 13: 39-42.—Smirnov, A. I. [Cases of sudden heart failure] Klin. med., Moskva, 1929, 7: 473-83.—Strong, G. F. Acute con- gestive heart failure. Canad. M. Ass. J., 1939, 41: 491-3 — Vidal, J. Insuffisance cardiaque aigue succedant k la section partielle d'un appareil pl&tre comprimant legerement un mem- bre inferieur. Ann. med. leg., 1939, 19: 425-9.—Wahib Nini. Trois cas d'artet du cceur traites avec sUcces par l'injection intracardiaque (adrenaline, 2 cas; atropine, 1 cas) Bull. Soc. nat. chir., Par., 1933, 59: 598-608. ---- Age of patient. Prim, A. *Etude de la decompensation dea cardiopathies a la menopause. 68p. 24cm. Par., 1939. Dressier, O. Certain pathologies responsible for heart failures in middle life. J. Am. Osteopath. Ass., 1936-37, 36: 213-6.—Edens, E. Ueber die Herzschwache im Alter und ihre Behandlung. Zschr. Altersforsch., 1938-39, 1: 115-20 — Knighton, J. E. The failing heart of middle life. N. Orleans M. & S. J., 1934, 86: 783-6.—Matthews, W. J. The failing heart of middle life. J. Tennessee M. Ass., 1933, 26: 29-34.— Pardee, H. E. B. The failing heart of middle life. N. York State J. M., 1934, 34: 451-5.—Riesman, D. The failing heart of middle life. Ann. Int. M., 1929-30, 3: 112-21.—Robertson, W. E. The failing heart in later life. J. Med. Pract., 1936, 1: 12; 37.—Schonemann, H. Herzfehler im Greisenalter. Miinch. med. Wschr., 1926, 73: 1358.—Simmons, C. L. The failing heart in middle life. Mississippi Doctor, 1934-35, 12: 32.— Wiggins, J. P. - The failing heart in middle age. Ibid., 1936-37, 14: No. 2, 29-32.—Wilson, R. Some factors concerned in heart failure in middle life. South. M. & S., 1938, 100: 7-10. ---- Blood circulation and blood volume. Albers, D. Die Viskositiit des Blutes in der kardialen Herz- insuffizienz. Zschr. Kreislaufforsch., 1937, 29: 914-25.— Basok, M. J., & Shesterikova, T. P. [Mechanism of regula- tion of the volume of circulating blood in cardiac decompensa- tion] Vrach. delo, 1937, 19: 685-8.—Blood viscosity in heart failure. J. Am. M. Ass., 1936,107: 504.—Borruso, G. Ricerche sulla massa del sangue circolante nella insufficienza cardiaca. Fisiol. & med., Roma, 1934, 5: 15-39.—Buccianti, E., & Rossi, G. Ricerche sul comportamento volumetrico e metabolico del sangue nello scornpenso circolatorio da cardiopatia, con speciale riguardo alle differenze fra arteria e vena. Arch. sc. med., Tor., 1934, 58: 61-100—Cattaneo, F., & Proclemer, A. La velocita di circolo in condizioni fisiologiche e nelle cardiopatie compensate e scompensate. Gior. clin. med., 1939, 20: 241- 58.—Danzer, C. S. Retrograde capillary pulsations in heart failure. Am. J. M. Sc, 1926, 171: 654-9.—Dautrebande, L. Contribution k l'etude physiopathologique et therapeutique des troubles circulatoires dans l'asystolie. Arch, internat. med. exp., Liege, 1925-26, 2: 413-547, 7 ch.—Elliott, C. A. Circula- tory failure in acute infectious diseases. Proc. Interst. Post- grad. M. Ass. N. America, 1932, 7: 88-93. Also Clin. M. & S., 1932, 39: 11. Also Memphis M. J., 1932, 9: 121-5.—Grass- HEART FAILURE 289 HEART FAILURE msnn, W. Kreislaufdynamische Untersuchungen an Herz- insuffizienten. Deut. med. Wschr., 1931, 57: 1971-4.—Greppi, E., & Buceianti, E. Le modificazioni della massa sanguigna circolante nelle cardiopatie croniche; comportamento del plasma e dei globuli nello scompenso idrico. Arch, pat., Bologna, 1929-30, 9: 470-98.—Hitzig, W. M., King, F. H., & Fishberg, A. M. Circulation time in failure of the left side of the heart. Arch. Int. M., 1935, 55: 112-20— Hussey, H. H. Value of combined measurements of circulation time and venous pressure in heart failure. Med. Ann. District of Columbia, 1938, 7: 350-3.—Jancke, G. Die Stauungsnetzhaut als Aus- druck der Beteiligung der Netzhautgefasse bei Versagen des rechten Herzens. Klin. Mbl. Augenh., 1937, 99: 756-60.— Jouve, A. X. Exploration clinique de la circulation de retour au cours de rinsuffisance cardiaque. Paris med., 1938, 107: 385-91.—Landau, A., Markscn, M. [et al.] Sur la quantite du sang circulant et sur son comportement dans l'insuffisance cardiaque chronique. Arch. mal. cceur, 1934, 27: 453-509.— Levin, E. El volumen de sangre circulante en compensaci6n v descompensaci6n cardfaca. Actas Congr. nac. med., Rosario, 1934, 5: pt 4, 649. Also Rev. argent, card., 1935-36, 2: 354- 71. ------ Forma* de hipervolemia en la descompensacion cardiaca. Ibid., 17-25.—Lian, C, & Facquet, J. Mesure de la vitesse circulatoire dans rinsuffisance cardiaque. Bull. Soc. med. hop. Paris, 1935, 3. ser., 51: 393-7. Also J. med. Paris, 1935, 55: 530-2. Also Presse med., 1935, 43: 328.—McMichael, J. The significance of cardiac venous congestion. Tr. Med. Chir. Soc. Edinburgh, 1937r38, sup., 117, 161-79.—Meakins, J. C. Circulatory failure in cardiac disease. Proc Interst. Postgrad. M. Ass. N. America, 1925, 1: 429-32.—Peco, G., & Montoreano, F. La velocidad circulatoria en la insuficiencia cardiaca. In Libro de oro M. R. Castex, B. Air., 1940, 1: 743-8.—Rogen, A. S. Blood viscosity in cardiac failure; its modification by administration of calcium gluconate. Lancet, Lond., 1940, 1: 780.—Schiirmeyer, A. Ueber Blutmengen- bestimmungen bei Herzfehlern. Verh. Deut. Ges. inn. Med., 1928, 40. Kongr., 388-91.—Sons, E. Stauunsstvpen bei Rechtsinsuffizienz. Miinch. med. AVschr., 1930. 86: 1501-8.— Starr, I. On the clinical characteristics of patients with sub- normal circulations in the absence of acute heart failure. Tr. Ass. Am. Physicians, 1939, 54: 163-71. ------& Rawson, A. J. Changes occurring in a circulation schema when failure of one or both sides of the heart is stimulated. Am. J. Physiol., 1936, 116: 150.—Vizer, T. [Changes in blood volume in heart failure, with special attention to postural changes] Budapesti orv. ujs., 1935, 33: 289-91.—Weiss, S. Circulatory adjust- ments in heart disease: a concept of circulatory failure. Ann. Int. M., 1931, 5: 100-16.—Zislin, D. M., & Rapoport, B. G. [Saccharine method for determination of the rate of the blood velocity and its variability in cardiac insufficiency] Klin, med., Moskva, 1941, 19: 142. ---- Blood pressure. Less, L. *TJeber die Blutdruckkurve nach Korperarbeit bei herzbedingler Kreislaufin- suffizienz [Kiel] 18p. 8? Greisfswald, 1933. Adensky, A. D. [Venous peripheral pressure and its diag- nostic value in cardiac diseases with decompensation] In Becueil Strajesko (Bogomoletz, A.) Kiev, 1935, 1013-32.— Cazalas, X. M. M. Les signes tensionnels de l'insuffisance cardiaque. Rev. Serv. san. mil., Par., 1937, 106: 57-90.— Cionini, A., & Robecchi, A. Sulla ipertensione arteriosa da insufficienza cardiaca. Gior. Accad. med. Torino, 1939, 192: 55.------Rilievi clinici sull'ipertensione arteriosa da in- sufficienza cardiaca. Minerva med., Tor., 1939, 30: pt 2, 541- 4.—Di Piero, F. A., & Azevedo, D., jr. Contribuigao ao estudo da pressao venosa nas insufficiencias cardiacas. Brasil med., 1931, 45: 309-14.—Duomarco, J. Rapports entre la pression moyenne arterielle, la pression moyenne intraventriculaire et le debit cardiaque; concept tensionnel et mesure du degre de l'insuffisance cardiaque. C. rend. Soc. biol., 1936, 121: 553- 5.—Eyster, J. A. E. Venous pressure in cardiac decompensa- tion. J. Am. M. Ass., 1927, 89: 128—Friedfeld, L., & Fishberg, A. M. The relation of the cerebrospinal and venous pressures in heart failure. J. Clin. Invest., 1934,13:49.5-501.—Kisthinios, N., & Gomez, D. M. Etude de la pression arterielle moyenne dans les differentes formes d'insnllisaiiee cardiaque. Bull. med., Par., 1931, 45: 583.—Levin, E. La hipertension venosa provocada como signo de insuficiencia cardiaca. Rev. med. Rosario, 1934, 24: 364-74. Also Sem. med., B. Air., 1934, 41: pt 2, 915-20.—Prusik, B. Die Bedeutung der gleichzeitigen Messung des Venendruckes und der Lungenkreislaufdauer fiir die Herzinsuffizienz. Verh. Deut. Ges. Kreislaufforsch., 1935, 8: 165-73.—Riband, L. Les signes sphygmomanometriques de I'iiisutrisance cardiaoue. J. med. fr., 1930, 19: 364-6.— Rothschuh, K. E. Ueber das Verhalten der Blutdruckamplitude bei der Kreislaufdekompensation. Deut. med. Wschr., 1938, 64: 436-8.—Soisdo, P. (Hypertension in cardiac insufficiency] Orvoskepzes, 1939, 29: 394-401.—Starr, I. Role of the static blood pressure in abnormal increments of venous pressure, especially in heart failure; clinical and experimental studies. Am. J. M. Sc, 1940, 199: 40-55. ------ & Rawson, A. J. Theoretical studies on an improved circulation schema whose pumps obey Starling's law of the heart. Ibid., 27-39.— Tetelbaum, A. G., Umanski, S. I., & Krynski, M. I. Ueber den Einfluss der korperlichen Belastung auf den Venendruck bei Gesunden und bei dekompensierten Herzkranken. Wien. Arch. inn. Med., 1935-36, 28: 121-32.—Tollman, J. P. Cardiac failure and hypertension; a case report. Nebraska M. J., 1941, 26: 56. ---- Cases and statistics. Bassi, G. Considerazioni sullo studio di 750 casi di vizio organico di cuore. Policlinico, 1937, 44: sez. med., 87-120.— Moses, H. M. Cardiac insufficiency; observations upon 787 hospital patients. Long Island M. J., 1927, 21: 279; 292. ———- The incidence of cardiac iasufficiencv. Med. Times N. Y 1932, 60: 369-89.—Munck, W. [Sudden death from heart-failure in adults] Ugeskr. larger, 1931, 93: 787-94.— Nobecourt. Syndrome d'insuffisance cardiaque de cause indetermmee, k evolution subaigue; mort par pleutesie et pencardite purulentes k staphylocoques dores. J. prat., Par., 1940, 54: 1; 13.—Rio Leon, R. Presentaci6n de un caso de insuficiencia cardiaca; asuntos practicos. Villaclara med , S. Clara, 1940, 8: 195-210.—Stieglitz, E. J. Cardiac failure; report of a case of cardiac decompensation of 14 months dura- tion. Ann. Int. M., 1932, 6: 406-21 —Thomas, D. R. Chronic heart failure with death from multiple emboli. J M Ass Georgia, 1933, 22: 66. ' ---- Chemistry. Lensing, H. *Uebcr Blutkatalase bei Herz- dekompensation und Tuberkulose. 24p. 23cm. Miinch., 1938. Becher, E. Chemische Blutbefunde bei Herzinsuffizienz Verh. Deut. Ges. Kreislaufforsch., 1930, 3: 139-42.—Ceruti, G., & Maestri. O. Modificazioni deU'equilibrio acido-basico nei decorso dell'insufficienza cardiaca. Arch. sc. med., Tor., 1931. 55: 73-110.—Fidler, A. Recherches sur les cations du sang dans certaines etats physiologiques et patholopiques, surtout dans la decompensation de I'appareil cardio-vasculaire. Bull. internat. Acad, polon. sc, 1934, cl. med., 13-8.—Heitz, J., & Nepveux, F. Des modifications cje l'dquilibre acide-base dans 1'insuffisance cardiaque; deductions therapeutiques. Arch. mal. cceur, 1927, 20: 169-76.—Herrmann, G. Insuficiencia cardiaca en terminos bioquimicos. Arch. lat. amer card Mex., 1936, 6: 49-68 [Discussion] 68-70. ------& Decherd, G. Some biochemical changes that accompany heart failure Tr. Ass. Am. Physicians, 1936, 51: 295-306.—Herrmann, G., Decherd, G. M., jr. & Schwab, E. H. Some biochemical factors of heart failure. South. M. J., 1936, 29: 386-94.—Klotz, R. Ueber das Verhalten des Glutathions bei Herzinsuffizienz. Klin. AVschr., 1939, 18: 1466-8.—Kylin, E. Blutkalkstudien; iiber Blut- und Oedemkalkgehalt bei.Herzinsuffizienz. Zschr. ges. exp. Med., 1924, 43: 368-70.—Meyer-Heine, A. Les modifications de l'equilibre acide-base dans la defaillance cardiaque. Rev. med., Par., 1937, 54: 511-6.—Milovanovic, J. B., & Stanojevic, L. Ueber den Gallenfarbstoff im Blute beim dekompensierten Herz. Zschr. klin. Med., 1935, 128: 163-73— Peters, J. P., Bulger, H. A., & Eisenman, A. J. Total acid-base equilibrium of plasma in health and disease; bicarbonate and chloride in the serum of patients with heart failure. J. Clin. Invest., 1926-27, 3: 497-510. ----— High serum bicarbonate in heart failure; asphyctic anoxemia. Ibid., 511-20.—Pivovarova, E. [Disorders of the blood chem- istry in cardiac diseases with defective compensation] Klin. med., Moskva, 1932, 10: 168-73.—Pdaer, J. [Significance of the Na/Cl index in cardiac insufficiency] Cas. lek. desk., 1039, 78: 760-3. Also Schweiz. med. Wschr., 1040, 70: 763-6.— Scott. L. C. The potassium content of the heart of persons dving from edematous and nonedematous conditions. Arch. Int. M., 1931, 47: 116-21.—Stanojevic, L. Die Zahlen des Gallenfarbstoffes im Blute und der Kieislaufzeit als Maszstab der Herzinsuffizienz. Verh. Deut. Ges. inn. Med., 1938, 50. Kongr., 155-8.—Volgin, O., & Stanojevic, L. Vergleichende Untersuchungen der Bilirubinamic und Kreislaufzeit bei Dekompensation des Herzens. Klin. Wschr., 1938, 17: 509-71. ---- Clinical aspect. Beers, D. L. Certain aspects of heart failure. South. M. & S., 1934, 96: 16.—Christian, H. A. Speculations on some prob- lems of cardiac failure. South. M. J., 1927, 20: 28-32.— Clerc, A. Considerations generates sur l'insuffisance cardiaque. Presse med., 1935, 43: 569-72— Hasenfeld, A. [Clinica) problems of heart diseases; luetic heart diseases; lesions and their diagnosis; treatment of insufficiency] Orv. hetil., 1931, 75: 1095-100.—Livierato, P. E. Considerazioni sulla insuffi- cienza cardiaca. Gazz. internaz. med. chir., 1928, 33: 91.— Schafer, G. Zur Frage der Narkose bei Yitium cordis und Schwangerschaft. Zschr. Geburtsh. Gyn., 1938, 117: 313-7.— Stanley. O. O. Important factors in heart failure. Internat. J. M. & S., 1934, 47: 123-30.—Wearn, .1. T. Problems of cardiac failure. Proc Interst. Postgrad. M. Ass. N. America, 1933, 264.—Yates, J. L., Rogers, M. F., & Morter, R. E. Myocardial deficiency from a surgical standpoint. Illinois M. J., 1923, 44: 253-68. ---- Collapse. See also Collapse. Dansaert, P. *Le collapsus cardiaque au cours des infections; son traitement par l'oua- baine Arnaud. 48p. 8? Par., 1930. 227475—vol. 7, 4th series- -19 HEART FAILURE 290 HEART FAILURE limine I'lcos vim Amstcl, P. J. de [Adrenalin injections into i !>■■ I > art] Geneesk. gids, 1934, 12: 217-23.—Danielopolu, D., & Msrcu, I. Principcs de base du traitement d'urgencc :i I'adrenaline; traitement intraveinetix a l'atropinc-adrenaline du collapsus circulatoire aigu; traitement de la syncope du coeur par injection intracardiaque d'atropine-adrenaline Bull. Acad, med., Tar., 1939, 3. sir., 122: 179-90- Loumer, E. Guerison rapide de 2 cas de collarsus cardiovaseulaire grave avec hypotension par injection d'hormone cortico-surrdnalc. Arch. mal. coeur, 1928, 31: 106-10. ------ Le eollapsus cardiaque. Bull, med., Par., 1938, 52: 951-5.—Klotz, R. Leber den hypotonischen Kreislaufschaden und seine He/.ie- li'iugen zum Kollaps. Miinch. med. Wschr., 1938, 85: 0S5.— I tbermann, F. Bekiaiii fung des Herzkollapses. Med. Welt, 1929, 3: 892.—Mecssen. H. Weitere experimentelle Lntcr- suchungen zum Kollai s] aobleni. Verh. Deut. Ges. Kreis- laufforsch., 1938, 11: 275-8.—Schoen, IL Pharmakologie und siezielle Therapie des Kieialaufkollapses. Ibid., 80-112 [Discussion] 112-21.— Wiechowski, W. Bekampfung des Herzkollapses. Wien. klin. Wschr., 102S, 41: 475-80. ---- congenital. See also Heart, Abnormity; Heart disease, congenital; also under proper names of congenital heart affections. Hanel, K. *Ueber angeborene Herzfehler unter besonderer Beriicksichtigung dos Rontgen- und des Sektionsbefundes [Berlin] 21p. 21cm. Hamb., 1937. Kaxzi.er, H. AV. *Zur Kasuistik und ront genologischen Ditiunostik der angeborenen Herz- fehler. 41 p. 8? Zur., 1932. Kind, II. YV. *Lebcns(lnuer und Todesursache bei angeborencm Herzfehler [Heidelberg] 56p. 21 em. Speyer, 193."). Klein, E. *Das Schicksal der Kinder mit angeborenen Ilerzfchlern. 24p. 8? Bresl.. 1935. May, M. *Die Diagnose des angeborenen Vitiura cordis vor der Geburt. 40p. 8? Bonn, 1929. Rosenberg, I. ^Beitrag zur Klinik dor ange- borenen Herzfehler (Auszug) [Leipzig] 6p. 8? Chemnitz, 1928. Voxbero [O. J.] G. *Zwei Beitrage zur klini- schen Diagnostik angeborener Herzfehler. p.221- 38. 8? Berl., 1931. Also Zschr. Kinderh., 1931, 51: Adlersberg. D. Herz eines Falles von kongenitalem Vitium Wien. med. Wschr., 1926, 76: 18— Arkusski, J. Zur Frage Mer Rontgendiagnostik der angeborenen Herzfehler, basiert auf 23 Falle, von dencn 2 durch Sektion bestatigt wurden. Fortsch. Rontgenstrahl, 1026. 35: 455-60.—Ascoli, M. Vizi n'liL-.niii di cuore. Cazz. osp., 1929, 50: 1331-3. Also Gior. ned Alto Adige, 1020, 1: No. 9, 3-11.—Ash, R., Wolman, I. J.. A: Bromer. R. S. Diagnosis of congenital cardiac defects m intanc\ ; a study of 32 cases with necropsies. Am. J. Dis. ( luM. 1939, 58: S- 2 :s.—Attinger, E. Angeborene Herzfehler. S hu. i/ in. I. Wschr., 1936, 06: 1056-9.—Biedermann, J. Kongenitales Vitium bei einer Erwachscnen. Klin. Wschr., 1026. 5: 1899.—Blumenfeldt, E., A: W, llheim, E. Zur klini- schen Beurteilung angeborener Heizfellir. Ibid., 1927, 6: 396-9.—Fogelson. L. L. A- Uorissov, E. I. [Differential diag- nosis of congenital cardiac in-u(!irieiaie>] Med. biol. J., Leningr.. 1927, 3: 16-28.—Ginzburg. J. Ueber die Augen- \ eiandcrungcn bei angeborenen Herzfeblern mit Polyglobulie Klin. Mbl. Augenh., 1928, 81: 591-607.—Golnik, R". F., & 'Irtlirrov, K. A. [Rare case of combined congenital and ac- quired heart defect] Vrach. delo, 1940, 22: 691-4.—Hecht, A. F. Die Prognose der angeborenen Herzfehler. Kinderarztl. Prax., 1934, 5: 7-1L—Hecko, I., & Vychytil, O. [Congenital cardiac defects] Cas. lek. 6osk., 1936, 75: 920-31.—Hillesheim, H. Angeborener Herzfehler und gleichzeitiger doppelseitiger Pneumothorax. Beitr. Klin. Tuberk., 1938, 91: 317-26 — Hitzenberger, K., & Tuchfeld, F. Blutmengeribestimmun" bei angeborenen Herzfchlcrn. Klin. Wschr., 1930, 9: 2150.— Hochsinger, C. Leber angeborene Herzfehler. Wien klin W">el,r:, 1928, 41: 1084; 1129.—Iancu, A., & Radu, S. Der angeborene Herzfehler ohne Gerausch als Begleiterscheinung des Mongolismus und der angeborenen Lues. Wien med Wschr., 1940, 90: 5.32-5 [Rumanian text] 535-9.—Kegel! V. A. [Case of conrenital heart defect] Sovet. pediat., 1030, \0 "in" 9173r;Khaiu«'n. D. M. [Congenital heart defects and tuber- culin] Probl. tuberk., M. sk\a, 1938, Xo. 9, 130-4-Kha- levj-ky, B. M. |On congenital heart defects] Vrach delo 1930, 21: 469-72—Knorre, G. von. Zur Erkennung ange- borener Ileizfeliler. Deut. med. Wschr., 1939, 65: 1385 —---■ Fin angeborener Herzfehler bei Zwillingen. Fortsch Rontcenstrahl., 1939, 60: 379-81. ------ Ueber Vererbun"' angeborener Herzfehler. Zschr. menschl. Vererb., 1939, 23: 695-720.—Larini. I). Sulla concomitnnza di alcune mal- formazioni congi'tiite (vizi cardiaci e petto ad imbuto) Riv. clin. pediat., 1927, 25: 384-9.—Lenk, R. Analyse des Riint- genhildes einer seltenen kombinierten angeborcni'ii Kardio- uithie. Wien. med. Wschr.. 1026, 7C: 719-21.- Llovd, H. J. i'ongeuilal eardiac defects. Minnesota M ., 1936. I!): 705-7.— I.urksrh. F., A- Stohr. R. Leber eine Her/feliler-limilic Med. KUn., Ilerl., 1936, 32: 1031- Mainzcr, F. Analyse eines kongenitalen Ilerzfehlers (zugleich ein Beitrag zur He- ilitnung der llumoglobiiacnnehrung bei Sauersioli mangel) Zschr. klin. Med., 1928, 108: ISO-512. Marcantoni A: ('aval- lini, F. Vizio congenito di cuore. Ann. med. nav., ILmia, 1027 2: 165-70.- Midvei. C. V.. & Rosier, II. Zur Hibbiologi.. angeborener Ileizfeliler. Zschr. klin. Med., 1931-32, Hi): 527-40.— Muller, H. Ein Beitrag zu den gutarligen ange- borenen Herzfeblern. Schweiz. med. Wsehr., 1927, 57: S62 'er- F- Ei»<: neue Definition der Herzsehwaehe. Klin \\schr., 19-11, 20: 390-3.—Mohler, H. K. Congestive heart failure. Med. Rec, Houston, 1941.' 35: 125-32.— Munroe, J. P. Congestive heart failure. South. M. & S., HEART FAILURE 291 HEART FAILURE 1934 96- 412-5.—Revell, S. T. R. Congestive heart failure. J M. Ass. Georgia, 1933, 22: 282-8.—Stiegele, A. Ueber Herzschwache. Hippokrates, Stuttg., 1936, 7: 686-8 — Stroud, W. D., & Bromer, A. W. Congestive heart-failure. In Cyclop. Med. (Piersol-Bortz) Phila., Serv. Vol., 1941, ] g5_7 —Teeter, C. E. Cardiac failure of the congestive type. J. M. Soc. N. Jersey, 1931, 28: 823-9.—Wharton, R. H. Some thoughts concerning early congestive failure. West Virginia M. J., 1936, 32: 415-9. ---- congestive: Diagnosis. Adams, W. P. Early myocardial insufficiency. Virginia M. Month., 1940, 67: 337-42.—Budelmann, G. Zur Diagnose der latenten Myokardinsuffizienz. Verh. Deut. Ges. Kreis- laufforsch., 1936, 9: 256-69.—Clerc, A., & Bascourret, M. A propos des traces eiectriques d'insuffisance myocardique. C. rend. Soc. biol., 1926, 94: 759^63— D'Zmura, A. P. Latent nonvalvular congestive heart failure. Pennsylvania M. J., 1935-36, 39: 309-13.—Erickson, C. W. Diagnosis and treat- ment of early congestive heart failure. J. Kansas M. Soc, 1941 42: 418-22.—Eustis, A. Diagnosis and care of the failing heart muscle. N. Orleans M. & S. J., 1926, 79: 50-8. ---— The D wight-Frost cardio-respiratory test as an aid in the early recognition of myo-cardial insufficiency. South. M. J., 1926, 19: 585-91.------Results with the Dwight- Frost cardio-respiratory test in determining myocardial in- sufficiency. Brit. J. Anaesth., 1927, 5: 13. ------■ The diagnosis of myocardial insufficiency; results with modification of the Dwight-Frost cardio-respiratory test. N. Orleans M. & S. J., 1928-29, 81: 605-11— Friedman, B., Clark, G., & Harrison, T. R. Studies in congestive heart failure; a method for obtaining mixed venous blood bv arterial puncture. J. Clin. Invest., 1934, 13: 533-52.—Graves, G. Early myo- cardial insufficiency. Med. Rec, Houston, 1930, 24: 631-4.— Kahlson, G. Beitrag zur Diagnose der Herzmuskelschwache. Verh. Deut. Ges. inn. Med., 1928, 40. Kongr., 421-4.—Lever- ton, W. R. Myocardial insufficiency; diagnosis and suggestions of treatment. Southwest. M., 1930, 14: 114-9.—Pruche, A. L'orthodiagraphie en serie dans les insuffisances du myocardc (evolution de quelques coeurs vus a l'ecran) Clinique, Par., 1934, 29: 100-8.—Starr, I., jr, & Gamble, C. J. Cardiac output in common clinical conditions, and the diagnosis of myocardial insufficiency bv cardiac output methods. Ann. Int. M., 1935-36, 9: 569-78— Stott, A. Recognition of myo- cardial deficiency. Lancet, Lond., 1935, 2: 946.—Strauss, S. G. The early diagnosis of myocardial insufficiency. Med. J. & Rec, 1931, 133: 123-6. Also repr.—Wood, J. E., jr, Capaccio, G. D., & Weaver, W. Venous pressure and body weight determinations in congestive heart failure. Virginia M. Month., 1935-36, 62: 271-6. ---- congestive: Etiology. Andrus, F. C. Clinical-pathological conference; myxedema and congestive heart failure. Minnesota M., 1941, 24: 963-5.— Bartels, E. C. Anemia as the cause of severe congestive heart failure; report of a case. Ann. Int. M., 1937, 11: 400-4.— Bauer, J. Die konstitutionellen Grundlagen der Herzschwache. Med. AVelt, 1930, 4: 983-6.—Boyer, N. H., Leach, C. E., & White, P. D. Underlying causes and precipitating factors of congestive heart failure. In Pub. No. 13, Am. Ass. Advance. Sc, 1940, 203-12.—Facquet, J. Une nouvelle variete d'in- Buffisance cardiaque; l'insuffisance myocardique alcoolique par avitaminose Bi. J. med. chir., Par., 1939, 110: 304-10.— Fahr, T. Zur morphologischen Grundlage der myogenen Herzinsuffizienz. Deut. med. Wschr., 1931, 57: 1185; 1235 — Lian, C. L'insuffisance myocardique primitive des maladies aigues ou chroniques et l'hypodynamie du myocarde. Progr. med., Par., 1927, 42: 118.5-99.—Mattioli, M. Una nuova variet;\ d'insufficienza cardiaca; l'insufficienza miocardica alcoolica da avitaminosi Bj. Riforma med., 1939, 55: 1217.— Neisser, E. Herzschwache auf der Basis von Erkrankungen des Blutes. Med. Welt, 1930, 4: 1134.—Ramond, L. Insuffisance myocardique primitive. Presse med., 1934, 42: 361.—Rostoski, O. Infektion als Aetiologie fiir Herzschwache. Med. Welt, 1930, 4: 1062; 1100.—Sodeman. W. A., & Burch, G. E. The precipitating causes of congestive heart failure. Am. Heart J., 1938, 15: 22-7.—Soliman, M. A case of myocardial failure of unknown aetiology. J. Egypt. M. Ass., 1933, 16: 506-9. ---- congestive: Manifestation. Austrian, C. R. Encapsulated hydrothorax (hydrqthorax saccatus interlobaris) in association with myocardial in- sufficiency. In Contr. M. Sc. (E. Libman) N. Y., 1932, 1: 101-12.—Halbersleben, D. Jaundice with gray stools during congestive heart failure. In Med. Papers (H. A. Christian Anniv. vol.) Bost., 1936, 115-21.—Kinsey, D., & White, P. D. Fever in congestive heart failure. Arch. Int. M., 1940, 65: 163-70.—Kohn, H. Herzschwache und Angina pectoris. Deut. med. Wschr., 1930, 56: 1641-4.—Korns, H. M. The nature and manifestations of congestive heart failure. J. Med., Cincin., 1937-38, 18: 543-9.—Lewis, T. Early signs of cardiac failure of the congestive type. Brit. M. J., 1930, 1: 849-52.—Smith, K. S. The pain and discomfort of congestive heart failure. Lancet, Lond., 1929, 1: 1080-5. C, & Ewing, G. Studies in congestive heart failure; the potassium content of skeletal and cardiac muscle. J. Clin. Invest., 1930, 8: 325-35.—Herrmann, G. A possible bio- chemical basis of myocardial failure. In Med. Papers (H. A. Christian Anniv. Vol.) Bost., 1936, 17-32.—Luten, D., & Wedig, J. H. The incompatibility between congestive heart failure and angina pectoris. J. Missouri M. Ass., 1940, 37: 96-8.—Pilcher, C, Calhoun, J. A. [et al.] Studies in congestive heart failure; the potassium content of skeletal muscle obtained by biopsy. J. Clin. Invest., 1930, 9: 191-6.—Starr, I. The increased noncardiac blood-pressure in congestive heart failure, and its bearing on theories of the immediate causation of this condition. Tr. Ass. Am. Physicians, 1937, 52: 355-60.— Stepp, W. Der Muskel- und Klappenapparat des Herzens bei Herzschwache. Med. Welt, 1930, 4: 1027-30.—Waller, J. Cause of increased fragility of erythrocytes in congestive heart failure. Proc. Soc. Exp. Biol., N. Y., 1939, 42: 64-6— Wilkins, W. E., & Cullen, G. E. Electrolytes in human tissue; a com- parison of normal hearts with hearts showing congestive heart failure. J. Clin. Invest., 1933, 12: 1063-74—Willitms, R. H., & Rainey, J. The causes of death in Datients with con- gestive heart failure. Am. Heart J., 1938, 15: 385-94 — Willius, F. A. The effects of protracted and recurrent con- gestive heart failure on the liver. Virginia M. Month., 1939, G6: 1-5. ---- congestive: Physiopathology. Barsoum, G. S., & Smirk, F. H. Observations on the histamine yielding substance in the plasma and red cells of normal human subjects and of patients with congestive heart failure. Clin. Sc, Lond., 1935-36, 2: 237-352.—Calhoun, J. A., Cullen, G. E. [et al.] Studies in congestive heart failure; orthopnea: its relation to ventilation, vital capacity, oxygen saturation and acid-base condition of arterial and jugular blood. I. Clin. Invest., 1931, 10: 833-55.—Cullen, G. E-, Harrison, T. R. [et al.] Studies in congestive heart failure; the relation of dyspnea of exertion to the oxygen saturation and acid-base condition of the blood. Ibid., 807-31.—Dieuaide, F. R. The nature and treatment of congestive heart failure; the clinical picture and its physiological pathology. Chin. M. J., 1935, 49: 397-411.—Grollman, A., Friedman, B. [et al.] Studies in con- gestive heart failure; a critical study of methods for determining the cardiac output in patients with cardiac disease. J. Clin. Invest., 1933, 12: 751-06.—Harrison. T. R., Harrison, W. G. let al.] Congestive heart failure; the mechanism of dyspnea on excr< ion. Arch. Int. M., 1932, 50: 690-720.—Harrison, T. R., & Pilcher, C. Studies in congestive heart failure; the effect of edema on oxygen utilization. J. Clin. Invest., 1930, 8: 259- 90. ------ The respiratory exchange during and after exer- cise. Ibid., 291-315.------& Clark, G. The buffering power of the blood and tissues. Ibid., 317-23.—Herrmann, G. Some blood chemical findings in congestive heart failure before and after treatment. South. M. J., 1932, 25: 934.------ Stone, C. T„ & Schwab, E. H. Some studies in the mechanism of diuresis in patients with congestive heart failure. Tr. Ass. Am. Physicians, 1932, 47: 279; 1933, 48: 364.—Herrmann, G., Schwab, E. H. [et al.] Concomitant clearances of creatinine, d-xylose, urea and chlorides during diuresis in congestive heart failure. Broc. Soc. Exp. Biol., N. Y., 1933, 30: 1375-9 — Herrmann, G., Stone, C. T. [et al.] Diuresis in patients with congestive heart failure. J. Am. M. Ass., 1932,.99: 16 17-52.— Landau, A., Markson, M. [et al.] [Volume of circulating blood in relation to chronic myocardial insufficiency] Polska gaz. lek., 1934, 13: 477-9.—McGuire, J. The role of the cardiac output in congestive heart failure. Ohio M. J., 1939, 35: 1092- 4. ------Shore, R. [et al.] The influence of congestive heart failure and of exercise on the cardiac output. Tr. Ass. Am. Physicians, 1938, 53: 93-8. Also Arch. Int. M., 1939, 63: 290; 469 —McMichael, J. The output of the heart in congestive failure. Q. J. Med., Oxf., 1938, 7: 331-53.—Markson, A. Blood viscosity in congestive heart failure. Glasgow M. J., 1936 125: 201-12.—Meyer, F. Herzschlagvolumen und Herzschwache. Klin. Wschr., 1939, 18: 1205-8— Miller, H. R., & Furman, M. Pulmonary blood velocity in congestive heart failure; velocitv in pulmonary venous circuit. Proc. Soc. Exp. Biol., N. Y., 1934-35, 32: 728.—Strauss, H. Leber- schwellung als Entlastung und Schutz bei Herzmuskel-In- suffizienz. In Contr. M. Sc. (E. Libman) N. Y., 1932, 3: 1121-4.—Waller, J. V., Blumgart. H. L., & Volk, M. C. Studies of the blood in congestive heart failure, with particular reference to reticulocytosis, erythrocyte fragility, bilirubinemia, uro- bilinogen excretion and changes in blood volume. Arch. Int. M., 1940, 66: 1230-45.—Wood, W. B., & Janeway, C. A. Change in plasma volume during recovery from congestive heart failure. Ibid., 1938, 62: 151-9. ---- congestive: Prognosis. Boyer, N. H., Leach, C. E., & White, P. D. The immediate prognosis of congestive heart failure. Ann. Int. M., 1940-41, 14: 2210-9.—Dry, T. J. Congestive heart failure; factors in- fluencing the ultimate prognosis. J. Am. M. Ass., 1942, 118: 263-6.—Goldring, W. Edema in congestive heart failure; effectiveness of diuretics as a guide to prognosis. Arch. Int. M, 1929, 44: 465-76.—Lian, C. Pronostico y tratamiento de la hipodinamia del miocardio. Arch. rev. hosp., Habana, 1937, 4: 213-5.—Schnizer, von. Rentenerhohung wegen Herzschwache abgelehnt (gerichtliches Gutachten) Fortsch. Med., 1926, 44: 1017-9.—Willius, F. A. Hypertensive heart disease, early ■---- congestive: Pathology. Harrison, T. R. The pathogenesis of congestive heart failure. Medicine, Bait., 1935, 14: 255-322. ------Pilcher, HEART FAILURE 292 HEART FAILURE congestive heart failure, establishment of eardiac function and a remarkably long period of recovery. Pro,'. Mayo Clin., 1941, 16: 793-5. ---- congestive: Surgery. Bailey. H. Congestive heari failure treated by complete thvroidectomy; result after 4 \cars. Proc. R. Soc. M., Lond., 1938-39, 32: "Clin. Sect., 1382.— Baute, B. J. Total thyroi- dectomy for congestive hcnit failure. J. Am. Inst. Homeop., 1936, 29: 7:;.' ."). Beam, S. F. Total thyroidectomy for con- gestive heart failnie and angina pectoris; ieport of a case. Ann. Int. M., 1940-41, 14: 2309-15.—Blumgart, H. L., Rise- man, J. K. F. [et al.] Therapeutic effect of total ablation of normal thyroid on congestive heait failure and angina pectoris; early results in various types of cardiovascular disease and coincident, pathologic states without clinical or pathologic evidence of thyn.nl toxicity. Arch. Int. M., 1933, 52: 165- 225. Brenner, ().. Donovan. H., & Murtagh, B. L. S. Total thyroidectomy in the tr«':n ment of patients with congestive heart failure and angina pectoris. Brit. M. I., 1934, 2: 624-9.— Eyster, J. A. F.. & Middleton, W. S. Venous pressure as a guide to veriest ition in congestive heart failure. Am. J. M. Sc, 1927, 174: 4*0-92.—Hepburn, J. Total ablation of the thyroid gland in the treatment of angina pectoris and congestive heart failure. Canad. M. Ass. J., 1935, 32: 390-3. Kahn, M. Total thyioidectomy in chronic congestive heait failure and angina pectoris. West. .1 Surg., 1935. 43: 253-iiO.- -Kennedy, W. R. The treatment of congestive heart failure and angina pectoris by the complete removal of the normal thyroid gland ia review of the literature with a report of 2 additional cases) Canad. M. A.-s J., 1934. 30: 610-4.—Levine. S. A., Cutler. K. ('., A Kppinger. E. ('. Thyroidectomy in the treatment of advanced congestive heart failure and angina pectoris. N. England .1. M.. 1933, 20!): 667-79.— McCreery, J. A. Total lh\ loidectomy for congestive heart failure and angina pectoris; report of 3 cases. Ann. Surg., 1936, 103: 136 12.—Middleton, W. S. Further experiences with venesection in congestive heai t failure. Am. Heart J., 1928-29, 4: 641-5 — Ransohoff, J. L. Total ablation of thyroid in the treatment of congestive lieai t faihue; ease lepoit. J. Med., Cincin., 1934, 15: 513; 1930. 17: SI. Also I',. We-t. Surg. Ass., 1935, 45: 540-9.— Riseman. .1. E. F.. Gilligan, I). R., & Blumgart, H. L. Treat- ment of conge-tive heait failure and angina pectoris by total ablation of the normal tie mid gland; the sensitivity of man to epinephrine injected intravenously before and after total thyroidectomy. Arch. Int. M., 1935, 56: 38-58. ---- congestive: Treatment and prevention. Chiaverini, R. *Tratamento da insuficiencia cardfaca congestiva por uma glic6side pura do Nerium oleander, folinerina. 165p. 23^cm. S. Paulo, 1939. A. I.., J. Tratamiento de la insuficiencia cardiaca congestiva por un gluc6sido puro del Nerium oleander. Dia med., B. Air., 1940, 12: 322. Allan, G. A. Treatment of congestive cardiac failure. Tr R. Med. Chir. Soc. Glasgow, 1928-39, 33: 77- 89.- Auer, A. Digitalis und Strophanthin in der Behandlung der Heizmuskelschwache. Zschi. arztl. Fortbild.,-1938. 35: 037-44.— Barnes, A. R. Significant objectives in the treat ment of congestive heart faihue. Collect. Papers Mayo Clin. (1910) 1941 32: 613-7.— Battcrman. R. C, Holman, D. V., & De- GralT. A. C. The therapeutic effectiveness and potency of digilunid in the treatment of congestive heart failure. Ann. Int. M., 1940-41, 14: 2058-72.— Batterman, R. C, Rose, O. A., & DeGrafT, A. C. The combined use of ouabain and digitalis in the treatment of congestive heart failure. Am. Heart J., 1940, 20: 4-13-53. ------ Treatment of congestive heart failure with an oially administered ni< ieurial diuretic. Ibid., 1941, 21: 9S-103 Beecher, ('. H. The management of congestive cardiac faihue. N. England J. M., 1933, 209: 1226-8 — Biondo, S. 11 tiattamento della fibrosi e della insufficienza del miocardio per mezzo della diatermia. Cuore & circol., 1932, 16: 2-32.—Bland. E. F., & White, P. D. The management of cardiac failure of the congestive type. J. Lancet, 1933, 53: 130-5.— Brady. A. S.. jr. The management of congestive heart failure. West Virginia M. J., 1939, 35: 479-82.—Bramwell, C. The treatment of congestive heart failure. Practitioner, bond., 1933, 130: 684-97.—Burstan, J. The nature and management of congestive heart failure. J. Med., Cincin., 1941—!2, 22: 61-7.—Calhoun, J. A.. & Harrison. T. R. Studiesin conges- tive heart failure; the effect of digitalis on the potassium content of the cardiac muscle of dogs. J. Clin. Invest., 1931-32, 10: 139-44.-Camp. P. D. The treatment of congestive heart failure. Virginia M. Month., 1938, 65: 221-5.—Chamberlain F. L.. iV- Levy. R. L. Clinical study of a preparation of squill (urgininj in the treatment of myocardial in sufficiency. Am. Heart J., 1937, 14: 268-83.—Chester. J. L. The treatment of congestive heart cases. J. Michigan M. Soc, 1928, 27: 262-4.— Christian. H. A. Chronic nonvalvular cardiac disease or chronic myocardial insufficiency and its therapeutic management Ann. Int. M., 1931, 5: 95-9.—Claiborne, T. S., & Logue, R. B. Lc" of salyrgan-theophyllin suppositories in congestive heart fail'ii.- J. Am. A.-s. Georgia, 1940, 29: 399.— Cossio. P., & Bcrronsky, I. Efecto hemodim'mico de las llamadas hoimonas ti.nl:aeas en la insuficiencia inii caVdicn. Hev. As. med. argent 1932, 45: 1345-50.—Davis, D. The role of rest and exercise in congestive heart failure; a program for treatment. N. Eng-. land J. M., 193.x, 219: 412 22. Dickens, K. L. The oral adnnuisiiaiiou of a mercurial diuretic in the treatment of con- gestive heait Uuluie. N. Orleans M. .V S. J., 1941-12, 94: 344. Dicuuidc. F. R. The nature and treatment of congestive heait faihue: pu v.anion and treatment. Chin. M. J., 1935,49: 507-20.- Dry. T. J. The management of congestive heart failure. .). Kansas M. Soc, 1911, 42: 92 0.- Faulkner, .1. M. The practical management of congestive lailurc Med. Clin, N. America, 1935-36, 19: 1563-70. Friedman. B., Clark. G. fet al.l I'lfect of digitalis on the cardiac output of persons with congestive lieai I failure. Arch. Int. M., 1935, 56: 710-23 — Friedman, B., Resnik. II., jr. [et al.] Effect of diuretics on the cardiac output of patients with congestive heart failure. Ibid., 341 --50. Friend, A. G. Ticatment of congestive hea't failure. Northwest M., 1941, 40: 53-7.—Gotsth, K. Prophylaxe der Heizschwaehe mit Strophanthin. Deut. med. Wschr,, 1937, S3: -I9S 500.—Greene, C. L. Vital factors in the treatment of chronic myocardial insufficiency. Minnesota M., 1927, 10: 538-51.—Guillaume. Le traitement de rinsuffisance myo- cardique par la glvcose et l'association glycose-insuline. Ann. Soc med. chir. Liege, 1934, 67: 43-50. Also J. med. Paris, 1934, 54: 920-3. Also Liege me;i„ 1934, 27: 529-42— Hiebcrlin, C. El tratamiento de las enfermedades del coraz6n; la in- suficiencia aguda v cronica del miocardio. Rev. espafi. med. cir., 1927, 10: 5S5 93.—Hamilton, B. E., & Schuck, C. A. Treatment of advanced cardiac decompensation (congestive heart failure) Med. Clin. N. America, 1938, 22: S53 65.- Harrison, T. R. The treatment of congestive heart failure. I. M. Ass. Alabama, 1934, 4: 1. ------ The principles of therapy in patients with congestive heart failure. N. England I. M, 19: 6, 215: 517-21.------The mechanism and treat- ment of congestive heart failure. Proc. Interst. Postgrad. M. Ass. N. America, 1937, 76-80.------Friedman, B. [et al.| The effect of therapeutic measures on the eardiac output of patients with congestive heart failure. Tr. Ass. Am. Physi- cians, 1934, 19: 158-62.—Hassencamp, 10. Zur Strophanthin- Iherapie der I !er/3Chwache. Fort-di. Ther.. 1938, 14: 281-8. Also Rev. med. germ. iber. amer., 1938, 11: 335-44.—Heim de Balsac, R. Importance de l'opotlu'rapie dans le traitement de certaines nrsuffisances cardiaques (myocudies) k propos d'un cas. J. med. Paris, 1931, 5}: 148-50. Herrmann. G. The modern treatment of congestive heart failure. Proc. Interst. Postgrad. M. Ass. N. America (1940) 1941, 359-66.-- Hines, L. I*\ The effect of diuresis by mercurials on the clinical course of congestive heart failure. J. Am. M. Ass., 1938, 110: 202-6.—Jensen, J. The treatment of congestive failure. J. Kansas M. Soc, 1939, 40: 273-7.—Karasek, F. [Criticism of lecithin treatment in insufneicnev of the myocardium] Cas. 161c. Cesk., 1935, 74: 462-7.—Kaspar. K. Herzschwache und ihre biochemische Behandlung. Mitt. Biochem., 1941, 48: 27 30. Kissane, R. W., & Koons, R. A. Spontaneous re- liaitalization following rapid diuresis in congestive heart failure, I i. Am. Ther. Soc. (1939) 1940, 39: 111-4. Knighton, J. E., sr. Tn a.t,ment of congestive heart, failure. Tristate M. J., 1937- 3S. 10: 1970.— Lane, L. L. The treatment of congestive heart failure. Hahneniau. Month., 1935, 70: 769-78 — Leonard, B. W. The action of digitalis in congestive heart failure. Med. Ann. District of Columbia, 1936, 5: 227-31 — Lerner, II. Treatment of congestive heart failure. Med. Rec, N. V., 1937, 145: 49-53.—Levitt. A., & Levy, I). S. The management of congestive heart faihue. Ibid., 1940, 151:27.— Lyons, It. The place of diuretics in congestive heart failure. South. M. .1., 1938, 31: 1059.—McElroy, J. W. Congestive heart failure (myocardial insufficiency) with special reference to raw diet treatment. Memphis M. J., 1937, 12: 135-7.— Mann, L. Die Elektrotherapie bei Herzschwache. Med. Welt, 1930, 4: 1209.—Markel, A. G. Congestive heart failure ami response to novasurol therapy. J. M. Soc. N. Jersey, 1928, 25: 255-7.- Marvin, H. M. The value of the xanthine diuretics in congestive heart failure. J. Am. M. Ass., 1920, 87: 2013-6.— Midler, S. Eine wirkungsvolle Behandlung chroni- scher Herz- und Nervenschwache. Naturarztl. Rdsch., 1936, 8: 339-44.—Parker, R. L. Complications in the management of congestive heart failure; report, of case. Proc. Mayo Clin., 1940, 15: 218-20. Also In Card. Clinics (Willius, F. A.) S. Louis, 1941, 250-3.—Paullin, .1. E., & Minnich, W. R. The treatment of congestive heart failure. South. M. J., 1936, 29: 400-3.—Rainey, W. T. The management of congestive heart failure. North Carolina M. J., 1941, 2: 645-8.—Raisbeck, M. J. The management of chronic congestive heart failure. J. Am. Inst. Homeop., 1935, 28: 719-22.—Resnik, H., jr, Fried- man, B., it Harrison, T. It. Effect of certain therapeutic meas- ures on the cardiac output of patients with congestive heart failure. Arch. Int. M., 1935, 56: 891-903.—Robertson, H. F., & Faust, F. B. Theophylline with inoinopanolainine in heart; with especial reference to congestive failure. .1. Lab. Clin. M., 1939-40, 25: 1066-9.—Rosin, H. Die Hehandhing der Herz- schwache mit Berucksichtigung neuerer 1'orschungsseigebnisRe. In Herzneurosen &c. (Ver. Bad-Xaiihcim Aerzte) Dresd., 1932, 61-75— Scholz, W. Die Behandlung der Herzschuache. Wien. klin. Wschr.. 1928, 41: 1283; 1320. Schroeder, H. A. Studies on congestive heart failure: the impi rtance of restric- tion of salt as compared to water. Am. Heart J., 1941,22:141- 53.—Schultz, J. H. Psychologie und Psvchothcrapie bei Herzschwache. Med. Welt, 193(0, 4: 1321-3— Schurig, A. Leber die Behandlung von Herzschwiiche mit del trisclien Sirbmen. Ibid , 1936, 10: 1621.—Schwartz, B. A. Congestive heart failure; a report of 37 cases treated with digitalis and pentamethylenetetrazol. Ohio M. J., 1933, 29: 308-10 — HEART FAILURE 293 HEART FAILURE Siebeck Ueber die Behandlung der Herzschwache. Zbl. inn. Med 1936, 57: 456. Also Verh. Deut. Ges. inn. Med., 1936, 48 Kongr., 57-71.—Stewart, H. J. The oral administration of calcium chloride in congestive heart failure. Am. Heart J., 1928-29,4:512-20. ------ The use of calcium chloride given intravenously in congestive heart failure. Ibid., 646-60. _____The use of theocalcin in the treatment of heart failure of the congestive type. J. Clin. Invest., 1930, 8: 389-417.— Stone, ('. T. Treatment of congestive heart failure. South- west M, 1936, 20: 126-30.—Strauss, A. E. The treatment of myocardial insufficiency. Med. Clin. N. America, 1936-37, 20- 547-58.—Sullivan, A. G. Treatment of congestive heart failure, with special reference to nursing care. Trained Nurs., 1931 87- 314-8 ------ Treatment of congestive heart failure. J. Arkansas M, Soc, 1932, 28: 148-54.—Teitel- Bernard A Hypodvnamischer Herzzustand und Herzbormon. Arch. go's. Physiol., 1928, 220: 212-9.—Towers, J. R. H. The management of congestive heart failure. Clin. J., Lond., 1937, 66: 20-5.—Treatment of acute congestive heart failure; from the U. S. Marine Hospital, New Orleans, La. Hosn. News, Wash 1940 No. 7, 27-9.—Weese. Disritalisbehandlung der Herzschwache. Zbl. inn. Med., 1936, 57: 457.—White. P. D. The treatment of congestive heart failure. Maine M. J., 1931, 22: 182-6.—Willius, F. A. The treatment of congestive heart failure and its underlying principles. Texas J. M., 1933, 29: 76-9. Also J. Lancet, 1934, 54: 589-92.—Wilson, C. P. Diuretics and myocardial efficiency. Northwest M., 1931, 30: 94. ---- Diagnosis. See also Heart function, Test. Barth, K. Zur Diagnose der latenten Herzinsuflizienz. Munch, med. Wschr., 1933, 80: 1817.—Bilski, F. Leber erne neue Methode der Funktionspriifung des insuffizienteii Herzens. Ibid., 1931, 78: 523. Also Zschr. klin. Med., 1931, 117: 553- 62 —Brooks, H. The failing heart: its recognition and manage- ment. Med. Clin. N. America, 1934, 18: 727-39.—Budelmann, G. Insuficiencia cardiaca, insuficiencia circulatoria e insufi- ciencia coronaria; estudio de conjunto para la prlctica. Dia raid., B. Air., 1940, 12: 532-7.—Cadwallader, R. Masked cardiac decompensa.tion. Am. Med., 1932, 38: 58-61.— Crisafulli. A., & Colacresi, A. La prova di carico con lattato di sodio per la diagnosi di insufficienza cardiaca. Cuore & circol, 1937, 21: 557-70.—Estape, F. de A. Insuficiencia cardfaca y colapso: diagnostico diferencial y tratamiento. Rev. mdd. Barcelona, 1929, 11: 150-64.—Fraenkel, A., & Thauer, R. Die intravenose Strophanthininjektion als Diag- nosticum fur die Herzinsuffizienz. Erg. inn. Med. Kinderh., 1934, 46: 20S-35.—Giraud, G., Ravoire, J.. & Barati, H. Quelques donm'es complenientaires au sujet de la capillaro- scopie chez les insiiffisaiits cardiaques. Montpellier med., 1939, 3 ser 16: 247-o0.—Harrison, T. R. The diagnosis of heart failure'. J. Am. M. Ass., 1940, 115: 524-7.—Mottola, N. Per la diagnosi della insufficienza di cuore latente. Morgagni, 1934 76: 301.—Paessler. Die Diagnose der Herzinsuffizienz. Zschr. arztl. Fortbild., 1928, 25: 301-3—Pletnev, D. D. [Functional diagnosis in insufficiency of the heart] Klin, med., Moskva, 1933, 11: 715-26. Also Zschr. klin. Med., 1935, 128: 386-400.—Reifenstein, E. C. The recognition and treatment of cardiac emergencies. N. York State J. AL, 1939, 39: 1339- 46.—Remen, L. Ueber Herzinsuffizienz mit latenten Oedemen und deren Priifting durch den Kauffmannsehen Versuch. Aerztl. Rdsch., 1931, 41: 282-4.—Richards, D. W., jr, Caughey, J. L. fet al.] Intravenous saline infusion as a clinical test, for right-heart and left-heart failure. Tr. Ass. Am. Physicians, 1937, 52: 250-8.—Robinson. J. B. The evidence of heart failure. Guy's Hosp. Gaz., Lond., 1928, 42: 182-9—Sallom A. K. The use of the damatized (') heart sounds for the early detection of cardiac failure. Med. Rec, N. Y., 1938, 148: 292.—Sooky, E. [Examination of latent cardiac insufficiency] Orv. hetil, 1935, 79: 211-3.—Starr, I. Failure of the heart versus weakness of circulation. In Pub. No. 13 Am. Ass. Advance. Sc, 1940, 195-202.— Wolferth. C. C. Diagnosis of heart failure, acute and chronic. Med. Clin. N. America, 1927, 10: 1459-68. —- Digestive system. Zorman, M. *Lcs troubles gastriques des cardiaques defaillants. 31p. 8? Par., 1935. Bevilacqua, L. Alterazioni del rilievo mucosa dello stomaco in scompenso cardiaco. Arch. itil. mal. app. diger., 1939, 8: 160-2.—Boland, E. W., & Willius, F. A. Changes in the liver produced by chronic passive congestion with special reference to the problem of cardiac cirrhosis. Arch. Int. M , 1938, 62: 723-39.—Branisteanu. D., & Fainita, I. Die dyspeptischen Storungen bei Kranken mit chronischer Herzinsuffizienz. Arch. Verdauungskr., 1935. 57: 15-25.—Day, T. D., & Arm- strong, T. G. Fibrosis of the liver in heart failure. J. Path. Bact., 1940, 50: 221-6, 2 pl—Di Prifco. L'esplorazione funzionale del fegato nei corso dcTasistolia. Fol. med., Nap., 1936 22: 73-8 —Herman, K. Ueber den Herzfehlermagen. Wien. med. Wschr., 1927, 77: 657.—Rahier. C. Le chimisme gastrique dans l'insuffisance cardiaque. Presse mdl., 1931, 39: 855-7.—Routier. D., Cottet, J.. . 14: 219; 239.—Schnizer, von. Dienstbeschadigung fQr einen Hei zfehler abgelehnt. Foitsch. Med., 1926, 44: 1087. ------ Dienstliescliiidigung fiir einen verschlinimertcn Herz- fehler angenommen. Med. Klin., Berl, 1928, 24: 501.— Schiineberg. Herzfehler und Tauglichkeit fiir den Dienst in der Wehrmacht. Arzt & Sport, 1936, 2: 77-9. ---- Heart. Avdeev, M. I., Weinberg, S. B. [et al] [Histopathology of the extramural nervous system of the heart in sudden death caused by caidiac insuffcicncy] Tr. Vseross. Konf. patologov (1934) 1935, Moskva, 20-2. —Fahr, T. Braune Pigmentierung des Herzens und lleizinsuflizienz. Klin. Wschr., 1929, 8: 693.— Kut.'chera-Aichbcrgen, H. Der Herzmuskel bei Herz- schwache. Verb. Deut. Ges. inn. Med., 1928, 40. Kongr., 415-20.—Poolillo, S. Sulle prove di attitudine funzionale del miocardio nelle insufficienze latenti. Gior. med. mil, 1932, 80: 894-913. ---- Hematopoietic system and blood cells. Buccianti, E., & Rossi, G. La resistenza osmotica degli eritrociti arteriosi e venosi nello scompenso circolatorio da cardiopatia. Minerva med., Tor., 1934, 25: pt 2, 840-4.— Heilmeyer, L. Der Blutfarbstoffwechsel bei dekompensierterj Herzkranken. Verh. Deut. Ges. inn. Med., 1931, 43. Kongr., 169-72.—Lelhaus, H. Ueber das Verhalten der Erythrozyten und des Hiimoglobins bei Herzfehlern. Verh. Deut. Ges. Kreislaufforsch., 1934, 7: 311.—Levina, Z. A. [Hemopoiesis and hemolvsis in grave chronic caidiac insufficiency] Klin, med., Moskva, 1941, 19: No. 4, 32-43. ------& Drubich, L. S. [Increase in degeneration of erythrocytes in cardiac insufficiency] Ter. arkh , 1937, 15: 432-46.—Levina, Z. A., & Granovskaia S. E. [Investigation of the fragility of blood capillaries in cardio-vascular insufficiency and other pathological states] Kazan, meI. J., 1940, 36: Xo. 5, 32-7.— Maire. G., Fricker. J. [et al] A propos d'un cas d'asystolie avec grande eosinophilic sanguine. Pull. Soc. mid. hop. Paris, 1936, 3. ser., 52: 1307- 11.—Rosenblat, F. J., <& Guseva, N. G. [Inhibition of the sedimentation reaction in circulatory insufficiency] Klin, med Moskva, 1941, 19: 127-34—Saragea, T., & Prizant, M. Sin la concentraticn globulaire chez les cardiaques insuffisants Bull. Soc. med. hop. Bucarest, 1926, 8: 12-8. hypertensive. Flaxman, N. Types of hypertensive heart failure. Internat Clin., 1941, n. ser., 4, 1: 25-30. Also repr.—Grossmann, M. Zur Prognose und Therapie des kardial dekompensierten Hyper- tonikers. Schweiz. med. Wschr., 1933, 63: 633-7.—Herve, L.. L., & Dortoso Infante, A. El factor coronario como causa de insuficiencia cardiaca en la hipertension arterial. Rev m6d Chile, 1939, 67: 1023-9.—Lisa, J. R. The decompensated hypertensive heart. J. Lab. Clin. M., 1931, 17: 211-5 : 621; 1928, 56: 86.— Meakins, J. <'. The mechanism cf heart failure. Mod. Con- cepts Card. Dis., N. Y., 1934, 3: No. 10, 1; No. 11, 1. Miranda. 1'. de P. Sobre el concepto de la insuficiencia cardiaca. Medi- cina, Mexico. 1934, 14: 270-8.—Moe, G. K., & Visscher, M. 11. The mechanism of failure in the completely isolated mammalian heart. Am. J. Plnsiol., 1939, 125: 461-73- O'Grady, C. Broken compensation and heart failure!. West Virginia M. .1, 192S 24: 507-9 —Robinson, G. C. The mechanism and treat- ment of heait faihue. Kentucky M. J., 1932, 30: 509-12. ------ & Burwell. C. S. A mechanism of heart failure. Tr. Ass. Am. Physicians, 1928, 43: 49-54— Schwarz. H. Leber die Pathogenese der Herzinsuffizienz. Klin. Wsehr., 1929, 8: 385-8.—Swank, R. L., Porter, R. R., & Yeomans, A. The production and study of cardiac failure in thiamin-deficient dogs. Am. Heart J., 1941, 22: 154-68.—Visscher, M. B. The restriction of the coronary flow as a general factor in heart failure. J. Am. M. Ass., 1939, 113: 987-90. -----■ Heart failure as a physiological problem. Mississippi Doctor, 1939- 10, 17: 594-9.—Wolfer, P. Experimenteller Beitrag zur Frage der Reservekraft und Insuffizienz des Herzens. Schweiz. med. Wschr., 1929. 59: 595-7. ---- Pathology. Boxwell, W. Clinico-pathological demonstration; the pathology of heart failure. Irish J. M. Sc, 1939, 6. ser., No. 165, 698-700.—Cossio, P. Estudio anatomo-clfnico de la insuficiencia cardfaca primitiva. Sem. mdd., B. Air., 1932, 39: pt 2, 15-23.—Eguchi, H. Ueber Gehirnveranderungen bei Herzfehlern. Fukuoka acta med., 1933, 26: 86.—Fleckseder, R. Die Einteilung der kardialen Stauungsformen. Wien. med. Wschr., 1930, 80: 1015-7.—Garsh, O. D., & Zhmurov- Obakevich, V. I. [Cases of cardiac insufficiency complicated by cerebral embolism] Klin, med., Moskva, 1929, 7: 321-6.— Gherardini, G. Sopra un caso di cancrena delle estremita in una ammalata di vizio di cuore. Pensiero med., 1927, 16: 88-99.—Pellegrini, G., & Pelli, E. Studio di alcuni fenomeni umorali e dinamici del sangue nello scompenso cardiaco. Boll. Soc. med. chir., Pavia, 1931, 45: 515-67.—Pletnew, D. D. Klinische Studien zur Pathologie der Herzinsuffizienz. Acta med. scand., 1936, 88: 597-619.—Skala-Rosenbaum, J. [Occult hemorrhages in cardiac defects] Cas. ldk. desk., 1934, 73: 1370.—Uhlenbruck. Autoptischer Befund und klinisches Bild des Herzversagens. Zschr. Zellforsch., 1932, 16: 568-84.— Warembourg, H., Linquette, M., & Ravaut, J. Le spasme artdriolaire dans l'insuffisance cardiaque; ses consdquences thdrapeutiques. Presse mdd., 1938, 46: 1761-3. --- Pharmacology. Andrade C, L., & Weinstein Goldin, F. *La teofilina-etilendiamina en la insuficiencia cardfaca; estudio de su accion cardiot6nica y dc sus relaciones con el sistema nervioso vegetativo [Chile] 15p. 21}^cm. Santiago, 1940. Grtjnenwald, L. *La pression moyenne dans les etats d'insuffisance cardiaque; l'influence de l'ouabaine et de la digitaline en application intra-veineuse sur elle [Strasbourg] 162p. 8? Colmar, 1933. HtiNTEN, J. *Dekompensationserscheinungen des kranken Herzens in Munchen in Vergleich zu anderen Gegenden des Reiches [Munchen] 24p. 21cm. Speyer, 1936. Rumma, K. *Les modifications des proteinea du serum sanguin au cours de la disparition d'oedemes cardiaques traites par le digilanide C. 46p. 24cm. Lausanne, 1939. Barach, A. L., & Richards, D. W., jr. Effects of treatment with oxygen in cardiac failure. Arch. Int. M., 1931, 48: 325—17.—Bloch, H. Die Wirkung des Coramin auf das in- sulliziente Kaninchenherz. Helvet. med. acta, 1941, Suppl No. 6, 51-7.—Borruso, G., & Ceccarelli, D. Ricerche su I comportamento della mas.-a del sangue nella insufficienza cardiaca in rapporto con la, dimesi provocata. Riv. osp., 1935, 25: 382-99.—Dobozy, E. |Effect of oxygen inhalation upon blood circulation in heart failure] Orv. hetil, 1935, 79: 767-70.—Fahr, G., & La Due, J. S. A roentgenkymographic study of the effect of intravenous lanatoside C upon the di- astolic volume and stroke output of the failing heart. J. Pharm. Exp. Ther., 1941, 72: 14.—Gollwitzer-Meier, K., & Kriiger, E. Herzenergetik und Strophanthinwirkung bei verschiedenen Formen der experimentellen Herzinsuffizienz. Arch. sn-s. Physiol., 1936, 238: 251-78.—Gremels, H. Pharma- kologie der Herzinsuffizienz. Verb. Deut. Ges. Kreislaufforsch., 1939, 12: 310-26 [Discussion] 351-63.—Hata, H. [Leber Grossenveranderungen der Herzsilhouette bei der Behandlung von Herzinsuffizienz mit Digitalisblattern] Tokyo igakkwai zasshi. 1941, 55: 479-89.—Itakura, T., & Wada, M. Ueber die Digitaliswirkung auf den peripheren Venendruck bei HEART FAILURE 297 HEART FAILURE Asystolie. Jap. J. M. Sc, 1938-39, 5: Int. Med., 76-8 — Kovaleva, M. F. [Changes in water metabolism in cardiac decompensation as effect of laxatives] Sovet. vrach. J., 1936, !• 265-9.-—Krayer, O. Versuche am insuffizicnten Herzen. Arch. exp. Path., 1931, 162: 1-28.—Nakada, K. Ueber die therapeutischc und toxische Dose der Digitalis bei der Herzin- suffizienz. Tokyo igakkwai zasshi, 1940, 54: 555.—Nylin, G. L'influence de la digitale sur la dette relative d'oxygene dans l'insuffisance cardiaque latente k rythme cardiaque normal Arch, mal coeur, 1939, 32: 1010-9— Peters, H. C. & Visscher, M. B. The energy metabolism of the heart in failure and the influence of drugs upon it. Am. Heart J., 1936, 11: 273-91.— Riihl, A., & Wiehler, A. Ueber die Wirkung von Strophanthin auf den Gasstoffwechsel des insuffizienten Herzens. Arch. exp. Path., Berl, 1934, 175: 665-80.—Saragea, T., & Prizant, M. Les modifications du nombre des globules rouges chez les cardiaques insuffisants a la suite du traitement. Bull. Soc. mdd. h6p. Bucarest, 1926, 8: 126-31.—Visscher, M. B. The influence of drugs upon the physiology of the failing heart. Proc. Interst. Postgrad. M. Ass. N. America, 1937, 71-5. ---- Physiopathology. Simon, C. *Action des hemorragies et des Amissions sanguines dans les insufnsances cardi- aques droite et gauche. 60p. 8? Par., 1928. Altschule. M. D. The pathological physiology of chronic cardiac decompensation. Medicine, Bait., 1938, 17: 75-154. ----- The clinical significance of physiological studies in cardiac decompensation in man. Mod. Concepts Card. Dis., 1940, 9: No. 11, 1; passim.—Buinewitsch, K. Ueber Kom- pensationseinrichtungen des Organismus bei Herzdekompensa- tion. Zbl. inn. Med., 1938, 59:578-81.— Condorelli, L. Nuovi aspetti della fisiopatologia dei vizi cardiaci. Minerva med., Tor., 1934, 25: 305-10.—Cossio, P. Fisiopatologia de la insuficiencia cardiaca. Med. ihera, 1932, 26: pt 2, 83-9 — Dock, W. The anatomical and hydrostatic basis of orthopnea and of right hvdrothorax in cardiac failure. Am. Heart J., 1934-35, 10: 1047-55— Dufour, H. Reflexions sur l'insuffi- sance cardiaque, 1'oedeme aigu du poumon et la phvsiologie du cceur. J. mdd. Paris, 1930, 50: 849-51.—Enesco, J., & Popo- yici, G. Le travail musculaire et les modifications de la circula- tion pdriphdrique pendant le travail musculaire, chez les cardiaques ddcompensds. Bull. Acad. mdd. Roumanie, 1938, 3: 535-47.—Enzer, N., Simonson, E., & Blankstein, S. S. The state of sensory and motor centers in patients with circula- tory insufficiency and in patients with hvpothvroidism. Am. J. "Physiol, 1941, 133: 269.—Eppingcr. H., Laszlo. D., & Schiirmeyer, A. Ueber die mutmasslichen Ursachen der Lnokonomie im Herzfehlerorganismus. Klin. Wschr., 1928, 7: 2231-9.—Harrison, T. R., Friedman, B. [et al] The cardiac output in relation to cardiac failure. Arch. Int. M., 1934, 54: 239-55.—Katz, L. N., Jochim, K., 5_9-—Volnard, F. Therapie der Herzinsuffizienz: Kknik. Verh. Deut. Ges. Kreislaufforsch., 1939, 12: 326-51 HEART FAILURE 299 HEART FAILURE [Discussion] 351-63. Also Rev. clin. S. Paulo, 1940, 7: 92- 107—Warfield, L. M. Ihe treatment of the patient who has heart failure. Wisconsin M. J., 1935, 34: 546-52.—Werley, G. The management of heart failure and dropsy. Southwest. M., 1929, 13: 495-8.—White, P. D. The nature and treatment of heart failure. Med. Today, 1938, 1: 3.—Willius, F. A. The treatment of a failing heart. Med. Clin. N. America, 1938, 22: 1137-45. ---■ Treatment: Cardiotonics. Lambey, A. J. *Les injections intraveineuses de convallatoxine dans la therapeutique de l'insuffisance cardiaque. 189p. 8? Par., 1933. Albeaux-Fernet, M., & Ramadier, F. De l'emploi des glucosides du muguet dans l'insuffisance' cardiaque. Prat. mdd. fr., 1932, 13: 808-10.—Bacaloglu, (.:., & Focsa, P. [Com- bination of digitalin-ouabaine in cardiac insufficiency] Ro- mania med., 1936, 14: 258.—Binder, L. [The effect of Nerium oleander in decompensated heart diseases] Magy. orv. arch., 1938, 39: 551-7. Also Klin. Wschr., 1939, 18: 573-5.— Bloch, S., & Lappas, J. B. La digitale, pierre de touche de la ddcompensation cardiaque. Monde mdd., 1927, 37: 13-5.— Bone, J. A., Rolfe, D. T., & Turner, E. L. The use of atropine and digitalis in certain forms of decompensated heart disease. J. Nat. M. Ass., N. Y., 1939, 31: 1-6.—Bustos, R. Nuevos conceptos sobre asistolia y digitalotei apia. Rev. mdd. Bar- celona, 1928, 2. ser., 9: 248-60.—Corbett, A. J., & Beebe, R. T. Treatment of cardiac decompensation with digitalis. Albany M. Ann., 1937-38, 56: 114-21.—Digitalis in heart failure. N. York State J. M., 1941, 41: 493-9.—Dord, G. R. Deux . cas d'asystolie chez des noirs, dont l'un avec alternance, traites avec plein succes par la digibaine intraveineuse. Marseille mdd., 1926, 63: 723-6.—Dubos, L. J. Digitalization in cardiac failure. N. Orleans M. & S. J., 1935-36, 88: 606-10.—Eismayer. G. Zur Behandlung der Herzinsuffizienz mit Szillaren. Deut. med. Wschr., 1928, 54: 1324.—Estape, F. de A., & Gruen- baum, F. El tratamiento intravenoso con estrofantina de la insuficiencia cardiaca cronica. Rev. mdd. Barcelona, 193.r> 24: 3-20.—Freund, R. Die Digitalisbehandlung der Herz- Bchwache bei Infektionsbehandlung. Med. Woche, 1906, 7: 187; 199.—Govea-Pena. J. Insuficiencia cardiaca irreductible v ouabainoterajia. Arch. Soc. estud. clin. Habana, 1939, 33: 65-84.—Groedel, F. M., & Kisch, B. Strophanthin therapy in heart failure. Med. Clin. N. America, 1940, 24: 877-90.— Griinbaum, F. V. The employment of intravenous strophanthin therapy in chronic heart insufficiency. Med. J. & Rec, 1931, 134: 320-4. Also repr. ■—---- The systematic use of stro- phanthin in the treatment of decompensation of the heart. Texas J. M., 1940-41, 36: 476-81.—Herzog. F. Die Stro- phanthinbehandlung der Herzinsuffizienz. Zbl. inn. Med., 1932, 53: 1159-66.—Karpinska, H., & Zahradnik, A. [Appli- cation of digitalis in cases of cnliac insufficienev] Med. prakt., Poznari, 1935, 9: 253-8.—Keseling, B., &" Kamprad, W. Beitrag zur poliklinischen Behandlung der Herzinsuffizienz mit Convallan. Miinch. med. Wschr., 1937, 84: 1778-80 — Konig, L. Ein Beitrag zur Behandlung der chronischen Herz- insuffizienz mit Strophanthin. Zschr. Kreislaufforsch., 1930, 22: 457-68.—LaDue, J. S. La administracion intravenosa de digital en el tratamiento de la insuficiencia cardfaca. Arch. lat. amer. card., Mdx., 1941, 11: 49-62.— Lauter, S., & Bau- mann, H. Zur Theorie der Herzinsuffizienz und der Digitalis- wirkung. Klin. Wschr., 1929, 8: 263.—Lemon Torres, A. de. & de Almeida Ramos, J. Tratamento da insufficiencia cardiaca pela digitalina em altas doses. Ann. Fac. med. S. Paulo, 1929, 4: 205-64.—Lian, C. La digitale dans l'insuffisance cardiaque sans arythmie. J. mdd. chir., Par., 1940, 111: 77. Also Sem. mdd., B. Air., 1940, 47: 1033.—Livieratos, S., & Kisthinios, N. L'ouabalne par voie buccale dans le traitement des insuffisances cardiaques. Presse mdd., 1937, 45: 1179.—Lovtsky, I. L., & Schwartz, L. S. [Actual principles in treatment of cardiac insufficiency with digitalis] In Recueil Strajesko (Bo^omoletz, A.) Kiev, 1935, 1051-8.—Nakada, K. Behandlung der Herz- insuffizienz mit den aus Pharmacopoeia Japonica ausgc- musterten Digitalisblattern. Tokyo igakkwai zassi, 1940, 54: 572.—Nisiaev, V. V. [Intravenous application of strophantus with urotropin in cases of decompensation of the heart] Klin. med., Moskva, 1933, 11: 103-5.—Pletnew, D. Die syste: matische intravenose Anwendung von Tinct. strophanthi bei chronischer Insuffizienz des Herzens. Klin. Wschr., 1926, 5: 46.—Rimbaud, L., Serre, H., & Bcucomont, J. Action heureuse de Digitalis lanata dans 2 cas d'insuffisance cardiaque grave. Arch. Soc. sc. mdd. biol. Montpellier, 1939, 20: 329-34.— Salas Gonzalez, J. La digital en las insuficiencias cardiacas traumaticas; schok traumdtico primitivo y secundario. Rev. espan. med. cir., 1934, 17: 489.—Schaffer, H. Ueber medi- kamentose, insbesondere Digitalistherapie der Herzinsuffizienz. Prakt. Arzt, 1930, n. F., 15: 457-65.—Seide, J. Cardio- purin zur rektalen Behandlung dekompensierter Herzleiden. Fortsch. Ther., 1933, 9: 551-5.—Shmerkovich, D. Y. [Effect of intravenous injections of tincture of strophantus in cardiac insufficiency] Vrach. gaz., 1930, 34: 1142-4.—Siterman, L. J. (Intravenous injection of tinct. strophanti in insufficiency of the leart] Vrach. delo, 1926, 9: 587-91. Also Deut. med. Wschr., 1927, 53: 24. ------ [Subcutaneous injections of tincture of strophanthus in sub-acute and chronic insufficienev of the heart] Sovet. vrach. gaz., 1934, 38: 1439-41.—Vautrin. Sur Taction cardiotonique du scillardne en particulier dans les troubles de ddfaillance du coeur. Rapp. Congr. fr. mdd. (1925) 1926, 18. sess., 2: 229-31.—Weiss, R. F. Die Stro- phanthinbehandlung der Herzinsuffizienz. Med. Welt, 1927, 1: 1440-2. ----— Intravenose Strophanthin-Coramin- J=>£uerbelhandlung schwerer Falle von Herzinsuffizienz. Fortsch. ---- Treatment: Diet. Borst, J. G. G. [Elimination of salt in treatment of decom- pensation of the heart] Ned. tschr. geneesk., 1937, 81: 5664- 73 —Cornwall, E. E. Suggestions for the dietetic treatment of heart failure. Mod. Times, N. Y., 1931, 59: 115.—Dienst, C. Muss der dekompensierte Herzkranke dursten? Med Klin Berl, 1939, 35: 1598-601.—Evans, W. Vitamin C in heart failure. Lancet, Lond., 1938, 1: 308.—Hales, H. Treatment of intractable heart disease by colonic lavage and fasting, with a theory about the causation. Med. Press & Circ, Lond 1939, 202: 143; 154; 178.—Harris, I., & Mennie, R. The problem of fluid intake in cardiac oedema. Lancet, Lond., 1932, 2: 1427-30.—Krekel. Die Kompensation dekompensi- erter Herzen auf diatetiseh-physikalischem Wege. Hippokrates, Stuttg., 1937, 8: 870-4.—Muyden, N. H. van [Treatment of cardiac insufficiency with vitamine Bi] Ned. tschr. geneesk. 1940, 84: 4380-5.—Peters, J. P. El tratamiento dietdtico de la insuficiencia cardiaca. Dfa mdd., B. Air., 1931-32, 4: 051.—Proger, S. H., & Magendantz, H. Effect of prolonged dietary restriction on patients with cardiac failure. Arch. Int. M., 1936, 58: 703-27.—Schroeder, H. A. Importance of restriction of salt as compared to water in cardiac failure Am, Heart J., 1939, 18: [Discussion] 606.— Scrutinio, L. Utilizzabiliti dell'azione antitiroidea delle vitamine B per la cura dello scompenso cardiaco. Boll. Soc. ital. biol. sper 1939, 14: 563.—Smith, F. M. The diet and theophylline iii the treatment of cardiac failure. J. Am. M. Ass., 1928, 91: 1274-7. ------& Ross, N. G. The importance of diet in the treatment of cardiac failure. J. Am. Diet. Ass., 1928-29, 4: 15-20. ------& Gibson, R. B. The diet in the treatment of cardiac failure. J. Am. M. Ass., 1927, 88: 1943-7. Also repr.— Stepanov, N. N. [Dietetic treatment of cardiac oedemas] Sovet. vrach. J., 1937, 41: 1207-11. ---- Treatment: Diuretics. Fuller, H. A. Contribution a l'etude de la therapeutique cardio-renale la th^ophylline-ethy- lene-diamine. 48p. 8? Par., 1937. Schwartz, G. R. *Novasurol and salyrgan in the treatment of the edema of heart failure. 28p. 8? Wauwatosa, Wis., 1932. Ambraziejute-Steponaitiene, A. [Salyrgan in treatment of heart diseases] Medicina, Kaunas, 1932, 13: 88-96.—Bannick, E. G., & Keith, N. M. Further studies on the use of diuretics in cardiac edema. Med. Clin. N. America, 1928-29, 12: 1565-72.—Bedford, D. E. Salvrgan in the treatment of heart failure. Proc. R. Soc. M., Lond., 1930-31, 24: Sect. Ther. Pharm., 429-34.—Blumgart, H. L. Effect of diuretic drugs on the acid-base equilibrium of the blood in patients with cardiac edema. In Med. Papers (H. A. Christian Anniv. vol.) Bost., 1936, 191-203.—Boop, W. F., Newburgh, L. H.. & Marks, H. K. A case of cardiac dropsy of long standing treated by digipuratum and diuretin. Boston M. &S. J., 1910, 162: 173.—Celebonovid, M. Z. Vorsicht mit Salyrgan bei schwerer Herzschwache. Miinch. med. Wschr., 1935, 82: 388.—De Rosa, O. El empleo de la inyecci6n intravenosa mixta de novasurol y estrofantina, como diurdtico, en el tratamiento de las afecciones cardfacas. Sem. mdd., B. Air., 1926, 33: 1402.—Dixson, I. M. Salyrgan: its long-continued use in cardiac insufficiency with latent edema. N. England J. M., 1934, 210: 800-2.—Evans, W. A comparison of the mercurial diuretics in the treatment of cardiac oedema. Q. J. Med., Oxf., 1941, 10: 332. ------ & Paxon, T. A comparison of the mercurial diuretics used in heart failure. Brit. Heart J., 1941, 3: 112-20.—Fraser, F. R. The therapeutic use of di- uretics in cardiac cedema. S. Barth. Hosp. Rep., Lond., 1930, 63: 33-51.—Friedenson, M. Advanced cardiac insufficiency; results of intensive ambulatory treatment with diuretic meas- ures. N. York State J. M., 1935, 35: 165-8.—Harris. I., Rubin, E. L., & Lawrence, J. S. Salyrgan and ammonium chloride as diuretics in cardiac cpdema. Acta med. scand., 1934, 83: 23-40.—Herrmann, G., Schwab, E. H. [et al] On the advantage of alternating the vegetable and metallic diuretics in the treatment of edema of congestive heart failure. J. Lab. Clin. M., 1933, 18: 902-15.—Jacobs, M. F., & Keith, N. M. The use of diuretics in cardiac edema. Med. Clin. N. America, 1926, 10: 605-10.—Jones, H. L. The use of diuretics and the management of oedema in heart disease. Month. Bull Kansas City Clin. Soc, 1933, 9: 5-7.—Kramer, L. I. Salyrgan: its use over an extended period of time to relieve cardiac insufficiency. Rhode Island M. J., 1934, 17: 175.—Lambie, C. G. Novasurol and other diuretics in cardiac oedema. Brit. M. J., 1926, 1: 80-2.—Levin, E. Los efectos inmediatos de los diurdticos mercuriales sobre el volumen sanauineo en el edema cardiaco. Rev. argent, card., 1941-42, 8: 220.—Lotz, W. Ein Beitrag zur Entwiisserung bei Herz- krankheiten. Fortsch. Ther., 1937, 13: 53— Marvin, H. M. The value of novasurol as a diuretic in patients with heart failure. Proc. Connecticut M. Soc, 1925, 133: 151-66.— Mercurial diuretics in cardiac edema. South, M. &.S., 1935, HEART FAILURE 300 HEART FAILURE 97: 88-90.—Miller, H. R., & Feldman, A. Prolonged use of massive doses of urea in cardiac dropsv. Arch. Int. M., 1932, 49: 964-77. Also repr.—Morris, N., chwiiehe! Ibid., 1935, 82: 186.—Stewart, H. J., & Wheeler, G. H. The use of mercupurin in the treatment of congestive heart failure and in the mobilization of excess body fluid. Am. Heart J., 1937, 14: 526-39.—Stroomann, G. Harnstol! bei kardialem Hydrops. Ther. Gegeifwart, 1927 68: 152-5.------ Kombination mit Sauretherapie bei der Entwasserung Herzkranker. Fortsch. Ther., 1920, 5: 477-9.— Thomson, W. A. R. The organic mercurial diuretics in the treatment of cardiac oedema. Q. J. Med., Oxf., 1937, 6: 321- 51.—Tziwanopoulos, S. Salyrgan als Diuretikum bei schwerer Herzschwache. Munch, med. Wsehr., 1935, 82: 185.—Weese, K. Zur Behandlung von iru-uHi/.ienten Herzkranken mit grossen Harnstoffdosen. Deut. med. W>chr., 1934, 60: 615.— White, A. E. R., & Zacharin, I). The use of novasurol as a powerful diuretic in the rrdema of cardiac failure. Med. J. Australia, 1927, 1: 273.—Wood, J. E., jr. Diuretics in the treatment of cardiac edema. Northwest M., 1936, 35: 84-8. —— Treatment: Drugs, and biological products Bohan. P. T. The use of drugs in the treatment of heart failure. Soutbwe-i J. M. A- S.. 1933, 17: 424-9. Bourne, G. The use of din-is in heart failure. S. Barth. Hosp. J., Lond., 1936, 44: 5-9. Christian, H. A. Drug treatment of cardiac decompensation. .1. Am. M. Ass.. 1937, 108: 44-6. Also Pol. Of. san. panamer., 1938. 17: 1085-9. —-Dassen, R., & Gossio. P. Los extractos musculares en el tratamiento de la insuficieneia cardiaca y de la angina de pecho. Sem. mdd., B. Air., 1933, 40: 1274-8.—Dimitriu. C. C. Un cas d'asystolie avancde n'duite par le traitement mixte de digitale et calcium. Bull. Soc. med. h6p. Bucarest, 1926, 8: 252-4.—Eppinger. H. Ueber die Bedeutung des Strychnins bei der Behandlung inkompensierter Herzfehler. Wien. med. Wschr., 1928, 78: 1352-6.—Lian, C. Les prescriptions cardio-dynamiques et les mddicaments cardio- rythmiques dans le traitement de l'insuffisance cardiaque. Hopital, 1930, 18: 742-7.—Loeper, M. Les mddicaments mineurs de l'insuffisance cardiaque. In his Thdr. mdd., Par., 1933, 6: 51-65.—Manca, L. II rapporto creatina-creatinina nei cardiopatici scompensati prima e durante trattamento con glicocolla. Clin. med. ital, 1937, 68: 789-806.------II ricambio dei corpi creatinici nei cardiopatici scompensati prima e durante trattamento con glicocolla da sola ed associata a glucosio-insulina. Ibid., 1938, 69: 443-56.—Morawitz, P. Tratamiento medicamentoso de las afecciones no descom- pensadas del corczoii. Dia med., B. Air., 1936, 8: 508; 512.— Reuter. A.. & Pfaller, B. Leber die Wirksamkeit des Thionins, insbesondere bei dekompensieiten Herzkranken. Deut. med, Wschr., 1938. 64: 438-40.—Rogen, A. S. Calcium gluconate in cardiac failure; clinical pharmacology and therapeutics. Glasgow M. J.. 1940, 134: 147-62.—Romeo, A. II trattamento ipotiroideo nelle cardiopatie scompensate. Clinica, Bologna. 1938, 4: 142-53.—Schaffer, H. Zur medikamentosen und diatetischen Behandlung der Herzinsuffizienz. Wien. med. Wschr., 1930, 80: 1549-53.—Typograf, J. [Pharmacotherapy in cardiac insufficinecy] Warsz. czas. lek., 1935, 12: 117-21. ---- Treatment: Glucose and insulin. Akil Moukhtar Ozden. Le glycose et l'insuffisance cardia- que. In Libro de oro M. R. Castex, B. Air., 1938, 2: 937-43.— Bizzozzero, R. C. La asociacion insulina-glucosa en el trata- miento de la insuficiencia cardiaca. Dfa mdd., B. Air., 1931, 4: 157.—Carriere, G.t Huriez. C. [et al.] L'association du glucose et de 1 insuline au cours des insuffisances cardiaques; bases et indications de la mdthode. Echo mdd. nord, 1933, 37: 145- 163. Also Gaz. hop., 1933,106: 535-43.—Cura dell insufficienza cardiaca con lo zucchero e l'insulina. Gazz. osp., 1934, 55: 990.— Di Guglielmo, G. La glucosio-insulinoterapia nella insufficienza di cuore. Boll. Soc. med. chir., Pavia, 1931, 45: 101-13.—Dimitracov, C. L'insuffisance cardiaque et le nouveau complexe thdrapeutique; 1 insuline-sucre. Progr. mdd., Par., 1932, 421.—Esposito, G. Glucosio ed insulina nella patogenesi e nella terapia dell' insufficienza cardiaca. Gior. ital. mal. esot., 1934, 7: 43; 71; 105; 128.—Ferreira, O., jr. Assucar-insulina na insiifficiencia cardiaca; a estase basilar chronica. Brasil med., 1935, 49: 57-62.— (Jiroux, K., & Kisthinios, N. Sur laction thdrapeutique du sueie associd k 1 insuline dans l'in- suffisance cardiaque. Bull. Soc. mdd. Paris, 1930, 469-74.— Gomez, I). M.. & Puente Veloso. S. Tcrapeutica insulino- azucarada en la insuficiencia cardfaca. Progr. clin., Madr., 1931, 39: 649-52.—Joselevich, M. La glucosa-insulinoterap a en la insuficiencia cardfaca; sus fundament os, su tdcnica y sus resultados. Sem. mdd., B. Air., 1931, 38: pt 2, 2010-22.— Kisthinios, N., & Gomez, D. M. Action therapeutique du sucre dans rinsuffisance cardiaque. Presse mdd., 1930, 38: 1363.—Lian, C, & Facquet, Y. Insuffisance cardiaque (traite- ment par l'association de glucose et d'insuline) Rev. med. cir. Habana, 1934, 39: 78.—Lourenco Jorge, A., & Penido Sobrinho, J. Insiifficiencia cardiaca e associactio assucar-insulina. Brasil med., 1932, 46: 533-8. Also Presse mdd., 1932, 40: 1951-4.—Macchioro, G. Esperienze cliniche su l'azione tera- peutica dello zucchero associate all insulina negli stati di insufficienza cardiaca. Riforma med., 1931, 47: 1297-303.— Mascheroni. O. Considerazioni sulla terapia glu osio-insulina, nelle cardiopatie scompensate. Riforma med., 1933, 49: 11)29- 31.—Smith, A. E., & Luten, D. Study of glucose therapy in heart failure in advanced cardiac disease. Am. Heart J., 1934, 9: 437-46. ---- Treatment: Methods. Bischoff, L. II mio metodTdi cura della insufficienza cardiaca. Riforma med., 1933, 49: 1565-72. Also Schweiz. med. Wschr., 1933, 63: 114-9.—Cornwall, E. E. The direct treatment of heart failure. Tr. Am. Ther. Soc, 1925-26, 27: 223-30. Also Med. J. & Rec. 1926, 123: 816-9.—Fahrenkamp, K. Ex- periencias clinicas sobre el tratamiento del cardiaco descora- pensado. Rev. mdd. lat. amer., B. Air., 19.il 32, 17: 1-6, 5 ch.—Fraenkel, A. Behandlung finaler Stadien chronischer Herzinsuffizienz. Verh. Deut. Ges. Kreislaufforsch., 1928, 55-9 [Discussion] 63-8.—Friedenson, M. Intensive ambula- tory treatment of patients suffering from advanced cardiac insufficiency. Med. Clin. N. America, 1933, 17: 241-58.— Galata, G. Primo tentativo di cura della insufficienza cardiaca cronica mediante contropressione gassosa intrapericardica del cuore dilatato. Cuore & circol, 1937, 21: 518 IS. Giordano, C. O tratamento causal e sintomatico da descompensaeao cardiaca. Resenha clin. cient., S. Paulo, 1940, 9: 259-69.— Griinbaum, F. Die verschiedenen Grade der Herzinsuffizienz und ihre Behandlung durch Ruhe und Bewegung. Aerztl. Prakt., 1932-33, 3: 86.—Harrison, W. G., jr. Cerebrospinal fluid pressure and venous pressure in cardiac failure ana the effect of spinal drainage in the treatment of cardiac decompensa- tion. Arch. Int. M., 1934, 53: 782-91.—Hyman, H. T., . Pende, N. Tratamiento patogendtico de la insuficeaicia cardiaca. Dia mdd., B. Air., 1930-31, 3: 121.—Sanford, S. P. ( onservative treatment of cardiac decompensation. Ho.sp. News, Wash., 1938, 5: No. 18, 18-24, 0 tab.— Schoen. R. Die Nachbehandlung der chronischen Herzinsuffizienz. Jkurs. arztl. Fortbild., 1934, 25: H. 2, 45- 55.—Shelburne, S. A. Modern practical methods in the treat- ment of cardiac decompensation. Texas J. M., 1938-39, 34: 335-8.—Stanganelli, P. Terapia attuale dello scompenso cardiaco. Kinase, med., 1940, 17: 91.—Therapeutiques depletives dans le traitement de l'asvstolie. Progr. mdd., Par., 1937, 253-6.—Weiss, R. F. Fortschritte in der Behandlung der chronischen Herzinsuffizienz. Med..Welt, 1930, 4: 1180. ---- Treatment: Physiotherapy. Bessone, F. Su un metodo fisico di terapia dello scompenso cardiaco. Minerva med., Tor., 1926, 6: 33-6.—Groedel, F. M. Die Balnectherapie der Herzinsuffizienz. Med. Klin., Berl, 1928, 24: 129-32.—Lewis, T. A bedstead for use in treating cardiac patients suffering from congestive failure. Brit. M. J., 1928, 2: 977.—Lucherini, T. La rontgenterapia della tiroide nello scompenso eronico di cuore. Boll. Accad. med. Roma, 1939, 65: 20; 71. Also Cuore & circol., 1939, 23: 297-304 — Montellano, J. F. Insuficiencia cardfaca; helioterapfa. Prensa mdd. argent., 1934-35, 21: pt 2, 1293-8.—Partf. J., Gaily, L., & Orinstein, E. La radiothdrapie thyroi'dienne dans 1 asystolie irrdductible. Bull. Soc. mdd. hop. Paris, 1936, 3. ser., 52: 1335- 9.—-Pellegrini, G. La roentgenterapia antitiroidea nella cura dello scompenso di cuore. Minerva med., Ter., 1937, 2«: pt 2, 59-64. Also Strahlentherapie. 1939, 65: 330-43.—Stahl, It. Die physikalischen Methoden bei Herzschwache (ausser der Balneo- und Elektrotherapie) Med. Welt, 1930, 4: 1212. ---- Treatment: Principles. Barach, A. L. The contrast between the treatment of heart failure and peripheral circulatory failure. J. Michigan M. HEART FAILURE 301 HEART FAILURE Soc, 1938, 37: 497-500.—Broemser, P. Physiologische Grund- lagen der Behandlung der Herzinsuffizienz. Verh. Deut. Ges. Kreislaufforsch., 1939, 12: 289-310 [Discussion] 351-63 — Carusi R. Sulla nuova teoria e terapia dello scompenso car- diaco. Cuore & circol, 1932, 16: 98-112.—Chambers, M. S. Some basic principles in the treatment of heart failure. J. Michigan M. Soc, 1934, 33: 182-8.—Felix, W. Methodisches zur Darstellung und Beeinflussung von Insuffizienzzustiinden des Herzens. Zschr. ges. exp. Med., 1932-33, 85: 415-32.— Felter A. G. Some factors in the management of the fail ng heart. J. Iowa M. Soc, 1936, 26: 617-20.—Gamna, C. Dire- trizes fundamentals para o tratamento da descompensacao cardiaca. Resenha clin. cient., S. Paulo, 1940, 9: 248-57.— Giordano, C. Mezzi e metodi per la cura dello scompenso cardiaco nei loro principii e nelle loro applicazioni. Studium, Nap., 1940, 30: 31.—Kirk, R. Some points in the treatment of cardiac failure and their indications. N. Zealand M. J., 1932, 31: 410-6.—Leblarc, M. Inopportunitd et dangers des thdra- peutiques intraveineuses chez certains cardiaques ddcompensds. Gaz. med. France, 1938, 45: 203-7.—Lorin-Bpstein, M. U. [Is the intra- or extrapleural decompression of the heart rational in various disorders of compensation followed by enlargement of the heart] Russ. klin., 1929, 11: 116-37.—Martini, P. Grundsatzliches zur Behandlung der Herzinsuffizienz. Schweiz. med. Wschr., 1934, 64: 1103-5.—Marvin, H. M. Digitalis and diuretics in heart failure with regular rhythm, with especial reference to the importance of etiologic classification cf heart disease. J. Clin. Invest., 1926-27, 3: 521-39— Rathe, H. W. The salient features in the treatment of cardiac failure. J. Iowa M. Soc, 1935, 25: 203-6.—Tillgren, J. [Main principles in treatment of insufficiency of the heart] Sven. lak. tidn., 1935, 32: 1185-98, 3 pl'—Visscher, M. B. Physiological principles of importance in heart failure and its treatment. J. Lancet, 1937, 57: 309-11.—Wenckebach, K. F. [Decompensation principles in treatment of grave, chronic heart affections] Ned. tschr. geneesk., 1937, 81: 367-72.—Willius, F. A. Some principles underlying the treatment of heart failure. Nebraska M. J., 1931, 16: 136-41. ------ The physiologic approach to the treatment of heart failure. Collect. Papers Mayo Clin., 1935, 27: 574-8. Also Southwest. M., 1935, 19: 188-94. --- Types. Petermeier, F. *Dekompensationstypen des Herzens [Munchen] 32p. 8? Zeulenroda, 1936. Alexander. I. N. [Schottmiiller's gradation system ol cardiac insufficiency] Radianska med., 1938, 3: No. 2, 52-4.— Arrf liga, F. C. Diversos tipcs de insuficiencia cardiaca. Rev. mdd. lat. amer., B. Air., 1928, 13: 1243-89.—Buauet. S. La insuficiencia cardiaca en etapas. An. Fac. med., Mcntev., 1926, 11: 100-5.—Casabona, F. Tipo strano di scompenso cardiaco (contributo al cuore cardiaco) Rinasc. med., 1924, 1: 202-4.—Coombs, C. F., & Herapath, C. E. K. The 3 chief types of cardiac fai'ure; their discrimination and treatment. Clin. J.. lond., 1926, 55: 529-36.—Cross, F. B. The clinical types of cardirc failure. Med. Clin. N. America, 1927-28, 11: 1081-97.—Doljan, C. Hypercardie et hypocardie. Arch. mal. caur, 1928, 21: 30-4.—Donzelot, E. L'insuffisance cardia- que bronzde. Ibid., 1936, 29: 1-14—Fendel, H. Ueber larvierte Formen der chronischen Herzinsuffizienz. Med. Flin., Perl, 1930, 26: 164-6.—Insuficiencia (La) cardiac broncetda. Rev. argent, card., 1936, 2: -154-7.—Levin, E. Tipcs de asistolia (ensayo de una nueva elasifcacion) Actas Corgr. nac. med., Rosario, 1934, 5: pt 4, 553-61.—Lewis, J. left heart failure. Irish J. M. Sc, 1941, 6. ser., No. 190, 548- 57.—Lcvaglio, R. lo studio del'a picola insufficienza cardiaca. Cucre <$• circol, 1929, 13: 189-209. Also Gior. med. mil, 1929, 77: 68-86.—Mazzei, E. Los diversos tipos de insuficiencia ca.rdfs.ca, ccncepto de lian. Dia mdd., B. Air., 1929-30, 2: 881.— Sivori, L. Insuficiencia total e insuficiencia parcial del ccrpzrn. Trensa mdd. argent., 1936, 23: 580-6.—Stein, D. A differential study cf right and left sided heart failure. Med. J. & Pec, 1S32, 135: 574-6.—W?hi, M. F< rmes clinioues de l'insuffsance cardiaque. Gaz. hop., 1931, 104: 713; 751. '--- Urine. Kindier, E. *Kreatinurie bei kardialer Dekcrrpenpaticn [Berlin] 5p. 8? Lpz., 1936. ^lso Elin. Wschr., 1936, 15: Scfwochow, P. *Eie Ursachen der verander- ten HarnfarbstcrTausscheidung bei dekompen- sierten Herzfehlern [Jena] 40p. 8? Wiirzb., 1934. ^denfky, A. D. [Acid-alkaline disorders of the urine in various states of deccmrensaticn] J. mdd., Kiev, 1P38, 8: 117P-90.— Hirferegger, F. Iscsthenurie bei Herzinsuffizienz. ft'ed. I lin., Perl, H33, 29: 424.—Hcfrrprn, A., & Lutterotti, O. 1 hvrrxinbcrrrrende Wirkung des Harnes bei kardialer Dekompensation. Klin. Wschr., 1933, 12: 1941. --- Uropoietic system. Ftienre, G. [Intensification of the function of kidneys in cardiac irst ffciency] Cas. Idk. fesk., 1627, 66: 922-4 — Regnier. Remarques au sujet de I'dlimination des chlorures par le rein chez les malades atteints d'insuffisance cardiaque ddcompensde. Bull Acad. mdd. Belgique, 1931, 5. ser 11: 409-40.—Stewart, H. J., & Moore, N. S. The number of formed elements in the urinary sediment of patients suffering from heart disease, with particular reference to the state of heart failure. J. Clin. Invest., 1930, 9: 409-21. ---- in animals. Auchterlonie, L. A. A case of cardiac failure in a dog undei general anaesthesia, together with other points. Vet Rec Lond., 1933, 13: 44.—Harvey, F. T. Whistling hearts. Ibid.! 1935, 15: 262.—Jakob, H. [Cardiac insufficienev in the dog] Tschr. diergeneesk., 1929, 56: 553-67.—Ponari, A. I vizi cardiaci nella specie equina. Profilassi, 1933, 6: 274-7.— Wirth, D. Chininwirkung bei Herzfehlern zweier Pferde Wien. tierarztl. Mschr., 1934, 21: 689-92. ---- in the pregnant. See also Heart disease, in the pregnant. Domecq, Y. P. M. *Les accidents d'insuffi- sance cardiaque du post-parturn. 60p. 8° Bord., 1937. Fier, F. *Herzfehler bei Schwangerschaft, Geburt und Wochenbett; wann erfolgen die meisten Todesfalle? 24p, 8? Bonn, 1930. Lardi, F. *Beitrag zur Frage Herzfehler und Schwangerschaft und die abdominale Schnittent- bindung in Lokalanasthesie [Zurich] 51p. 8° Stuttg., 1927. Also Zschr. Geburtsh. Gyn., 1928, 93: Lowi, H. *Ueber die Komplikation von Schwangerschaft, Geburt und Wochenbett mit Herzfehlern. 51p. 8? Bresl., 1909. Muller, H. *Ueber Herzfehler und Schwan- gerschaft, bearbeitet nach dem Material der Medizinischen Universitats-Poliklinik, Leipzig [Leipzig] 21p. 8? Zeulenroda, 1933. Nawrocki, B. *Ueber den Einfluss von Herzfehlern auf die Schwangerschaft nebst Betrachtungen iiber die Therapie dieser Kom- plikationen. 31p. 8? Greifsw., 1906. Schreiner, H. *Herzfehler und Geburt [Heidelberg] 24p. 22#cm. Speyer, 1938. Selinger, B. *Das geburtshilfliche Vorgehen bei Frauen mit dekompensiertem Herzfehler am Fnde der Schwangerschaft oder unter der Geburt. 31p. 21cm. Ziir., 1937. Voigt [E.] C. *Herzfehler und Schwanger- schaft. 23p. 8? Kiel, 1934. Wiesmann, H. *Herzfehler und Blutverlust unter der Geburt [Bonn] 47p. 21cm. Bochum, 1935. Abramovitz, A. [Heart failure during pregnancy and labor] Harefuah, Tel Aviv, 1941, 20: 83-5.—Ahltorp, G. [Case of heart insufficiency in a pregnant woman during dorsal position] Sven. lak. tidn., 1932, 29: 1378-88. Also Acta obst. gyn. scand., 1933, 13: 67-80.—Bonsdorff, B. von. Severe myo- cardial failure, acute pancreatitis and hypocholesterolemia in a young woman, shortly post partum. Acta med. scand., 1939, 100: 390-402.—Broustet, P., & Mahon, R. L'insuffisance cardiaque du post-partum. Gyn. obst., Par., 1938, 37: 453- 62.—Consols, N. Glucosio-insulino-terapia n^lle cardiopatie in r-rnvidanza. Riv. ital. gin., 1933, 15: 699-712, ch.—Eafby, M. H. The early recognition of cardiac insufficiency in the presence of pregnancy. Med. Clin. N. America, 1937, 21: 1059-71 — Gautrtt. Insuffisance cardiaque et puerpdralitd. J. mdd. Bordeaux, 1930, 107: 869-75.—.Takowleff. I. Schwangerschaft und Herzfehler. Zbl. Gyn., 1927, 51: 2870-5.—Jaschke, R. T. Herzfehler und Schwangerschaft. Zschr. Bain., 1915-16, 8: 142.—Jonen, P. Ein persistierendes Foramen primum bei einer Siebentgebarenden (ein Beitrag zur Beurteilung kon- p-enitaler Herzfehler in der Schwangerschaft) Arch. Gyn., Berl, 1928, 133: 150-8.—Fehrer, E. Herzfehler und Schwan- rerschaft. Deut. med. Wschr., 1929, 55: 1969-71.—Kraatz, H. Ueber d'e Behandlung von Herzfehlern in der Schwaneerschaft und unter der Geburt. Fortsch. Med., 1933, 51: 1097-101.— Kiietner, H., & Schoen, R. Schwangerschaft und Herzfehler. Munch, med. Wschr., 1934, 81: 739-43.—Masufi, M. Ueber idioi ati iscl'e Herzmuskelinsuffzienz, die mit Schwangerschaft urisiichlich zusammenhangt. Tr. Soc. path, jap., 1938, 28: 254-9.—Meares, S. D. Congestive heart failure in the later months of pregnancy. Med. J. Australia, 1939, 1: 929-32 — Nardini, R. Contributo alio studio clinico della gravidanza eomplicata da vizio organico di cuore. Riv. ostet. gin., 1927, 9: 50-7.—Oppel. T. W. Conpestive heart failure in pregnancy. Am. J. Obst., 1940, 39: 24-32.—Pigeaud. H. Hypertension solitaire antdrieure a la gestation; ddfaillance cardiaque au HEART FAILURE 302 HEART FUNCTION huitidme mi is de la grossesse. Bull. Soc. obst. gyn. Paris, 1937, 26: 303. — Rojas, D. A. Cardiopatfas y embarazo: insuficiencia cardiaca en dos cardiacas embarazados; mtei rupcion del embarazo v eslerilizacidnsimultdnea. Sem. med., B. Air., 1926, 33: 446-52.—Salarich, M. S., & Viscasillas, F. Indicaei.'m de cesarea por cardiopatia descompensada. Ars medica, Barcel., 1935, 11: 82-6.—Schaupp, K. L. Cardiac decompensation during pregnancv. California West. M., 1926, 25: 63-5. Also Current Res. Anesth., 1926, 5: 30-2.—Schultz, W. Herz- fehler und Schwangerschaft. Deut. med. Wschr., 1933, 59: 1632-5. HEART function See also Blood circulation; Blood pressure; Heart, Physiology; Heartbeat; Heart conduc- tion, &c. Bogue, J. Y. Some recent advances in the phvsiohigv of cardiac function. Vet. Rec, Lond., 1939, 51: 991-S.—Chini, V. Contributo sperimentale alia conoscenza dei rapporti tra fenomeni periodici e alternant! del cuore. Policlinico, 1932, 39: sez. med., 317-27, ch.—Galata, G. Ricerche sulle leggi generali dell'attivita cardiaca. Fisiol. & med., Roma, 1930, 1: 781- 824.—Keating, E. Various activities of the beating heart. Illinois M. J., 1937, 71: 63-7.—Oana, M. Experimental study on the heart function; control experiment. Jap. J. Exp. M., 1932, 10: 157-75.—Perroud. Les bruits et les mouvements du coeur devant l'acaddmie de mddecine; revue critique. J. mdd. vdt., Lvon, 1864, 20: 453; 501.—Schwartz, G., Harvey, J., & Brown, G. The normal heart. Med. Rec, N. V.. 1941, 153: 121; 138.—Wood, H. ('.. jr. Heart beat and blood flow. Am. J. Pharm., 1930, 102: 9-21. ---- Adaptability. Moldavsky, L. F., & Visscher, M. B. An analysis of the factors concerned in the automatic adjustment of the ventricle to increased load; a study of the importance of contraction rate and filling pressure in producing alterations in diastolic volume by variations in arterial pressure. Am. J. Physiol, 1933, 106: 3-9-38.—Rupprecht, E. A review of eardiac adantabilitv. J. Detroit Coll. M. & S.. 1929-30, 1: 65-93.—Scheinlinkel, N. ITnterMicliungen iiber die Abhangigkeit der Arbeitsleistung des Froschherzens von den mechanischen Faltoron mit besonderer Bei tick-ichtigung der Konipensationsmi'mlicbkeiten. Zschr. Biol, 1929, 89: 171-85.—Wiggers, C. J. The physiologic principles underlying the adaptation of the heart. Northwest T., 1928,27: 469.—7aeper. Les limites de l'activitd fonction- nelle du coeur chez 1'homme sain et chez le malade. Bruxelles mdd., 1938-39, 19: No. spdc, 63— Zubkov, A. A. [Studies on the peripheral adaptation of the heart; adaptation of the heart bv means of the chanie of its sensitivity to stimulatory and inhibitory agents] J. Physiol. USSR, 1035, 18: 366-84. ------ [Studies on the adaptation of the heart; the ro'e of the adapta- tion of the heart in the Goltz phenomenon] Ibid., 539-47. ---- Cardiac cycle. Bethe, A., Bergmann, G. von fet al] Blut- zirkulation. 1. Teil: Herz. 862p. 8? Berl., 1926. Saixsbtjry, H. The cardiac cycle. 79p. 8? Bristol, 1931. Almeida Pintos, R. La constante sIstolo-diast6!ica de Lian. Dia mdd. urug., 1934, 2: 334.—Garrigou. J. Note sur les expdriences de M. le Dr Groux, sur la succession des mouve- ments du ccpur. J. mdd. Toulouse, 1862, 4. sdr.. 1 : 198.— Holzlohner, E. Der Atempuls (kardiopneumatische Beweguna) und der Rlutruckstrom zum Herzen; Volumen- und Druckpuls Zschr. Biol, 1937, 98: 281-301.—Land is, C, & Forbes, T. W. The relation of startle reactions to the cardiac cvcle. Psychiat Q., 1934, 8: 235-42—Przywara, L. E. Die Herzkontraktions- phasen bei Gesunden und Kranken. Zschr. klin. Med., 1933, 123: 406-31. ---- Cardiac cycle: Diastole. Bohning, A., & Plaut, J. Observations on the duration of the phases of diastcle in man. Am. Heart J., 1934, 9: 500-10.— Boyd. T. E., & Patras, M. C. Variations in diastolic volume and stroke output of the ventricles with the phases of respira- tion. Am. J. Physiol, 1941, 133: 220.—Clemenli, A. Sull'iper- diastole compensatoria nelle diverse classi di vertebrati e sull'ipersistcle post-iperdiastolica. Boll. Soc. ital. biol. sper., 1939, 14:569.—Cotton, F. S. Does the ventricle exert a suction action in diastole? Am. J. Physiol, 1934, 107: 178-82.— Eismayer. G.. & Quincke, H. Die Beeinflussung der Diastole des Herzens durch Ermiidung, Ionenentzus und Strophanthin Arch. exp. Path., Lpz., 1929, 141: 164-82.—Hamilton, W. F. Filling of the normal human heart in relation to the cardic- pneumogram and abnormal plethysmogram. Am. J. Phvsiol 1930, 91: 712-9.—Katz. L. N. The role played bv the ventricu- lar relaxation process in filling the ventricle. Ibid., 95: 542- 53.—Mansfeld. G. [Importance of the mechanism of diastole ('experimental physiology)] Orv. hetil, 1929. 73: 177-83.— Moritz, F. Zur I rage des diastolischen Fassungsvermogens der Herzkammern. Munch, med. Wschr., 1928, 75: 21-4__ Patras, M. C, & Boyd, T. E. Respiratory effects on the filling of the ventiicles duiiug vaooil inhibition. Am. J. Physiol., 1941. 13.1: 1(19. Rosnowski. M. [Question of duration of ventricular dia>to|e in electro- and phonocardiographic in- ve.-tinntions] Lek. wojsk., 1939, 33: 641-62.—Smetanku. V..& Hauiitfeld, R. Oiigine des forces qui assurent le remplis.iage du coeur pendant la diastole. C. rend. Soc. biol., 1927, 97: 1302-4. ---- Cardiac cycle: Duration, and refractory period. See also Heart muscle, Excitability. Albov, N. A. [Diagnostic importance of the diastolic pause of the heart] Vrach. delo, 1935, 18: 419-22.—Holzliihner, E. Ueber das Vorhofkammerintervall. Klin. Wschr., 1930, 9: 1708-11.—Magarasevic. Le rapport entre la durde de la systole ventriculaire et celle de la rdvolution cardiaque chez I'homme normal et au repos. Arch. mal. coeur, 1937, 30: 594-600.—Pop.esco, M. Recherches sur la gendse de la pause compensatrice du coeur. C. rend. Soc. biol, 1938, 127: 1341- 4.—Schlomka, G. Ueber die zeitliche Gestaltung der Herz- tatigkeit des Gesunden. Med. Welt, 1936, 10: 1279; 1315.— Schmitz, W., & Schaefer, H. Die zeitlichen Beziehungen der Tatigkeitsausserungen des Herzens. Zschr. Kreislaufforsch., 1935. 27: 513; 550.—Schultz, H. Ueber die Bestimmungs- moglichkeit der Anspannungszeit des Herzen. Ibid., 1937, 29: 425-34.—Stewart, C. C, McClure, G. G., & Stewart, D. R. The compensatory pause. Am. J. Physiol, 1931, 97: 676-88.— Tso, T. M. The effect of variations in the diastolic filling of the frog's ventricle upon the durations of the refractory period and the mechanical response. J. Physiol, Lond., 1929-30, 46: 441-53.—Weitz, W. Ueber die Bestimmungsmoglichkeit der Anspannungszeit des Herzens. Zschr. Kreislaufforsch., 1937, 29: 632-4. ---- Cardiac cycle: Systole. See also Heart muscle, Contraction. Kulczewski, G. *L'unite vitale myocardique; la contraction cardiaque a l'etat normal et pathologique. 72p. 8? Lyon, 1935. Raab, W. *Untersuchungen iiber die relative Svstolendauer im Ruhe-Elektrokardiogramm. 24p. 21cm. Bonn, 1936. Witsch, F. *Ueber das Verhalten der rela- tiven Systolendauer bei Fettleibigen [Bonn] 19p. 21cm. Koln, 1938. Bohme, W. Zur Physiologie des Herzens mit besonderer Berucksichtigung seiner Funktion als Saugpumpe wahrend der Systole. Klin. Wschr., 1935, 14: 614.—Cau, P. Sull'al- lungamento e raccorciamento relativo della sistole ventri- colare misurati suU'elettrocardiogramma. Cuore & circol., 1937, 21: 197-201.—Dagnini. G. Sul comportamento della durata della sistole nelle varie etk. Boll. Soc. ital. biol. sper., 1936, 11: 1017-9.—Dale, A. S. The relation between amplitude of contraction and rate of rhythm in the mammalian ventricle (including interpretation of the apparent indirect action of the vagus on amplitude of ventricular contraction) J. Physiol, Lond., 1930, 70: 455-73.—Gomez, D. M. Morphologie gdndrale du piezogramme arteriel humain et durde de l'dvacua- tion ventriculaire. C. rend. Soc. biol, 1936, 121: 1089 — Grosse-BrockhofT. F., & Strotmann, A. Die zeitlichen Be- ziehungen der mechanischen Systolendauer zUm Elektro- kardiogramm. Zschr. ges. exp. Med., 1936, 98: 227-38.— Henrijean, F. La nature de la systole ventriculaire. Bull. Acad. mdd. Belgiqu=, 1927, 5. ser., 7: 738-44. Also C. rend. Acad, sc, 1927, 185: 1160-2.—Hering, H. E. Ueber die elek- trographische Aehnlichkeit von Kammerextrasvstolen mit automatischen Kammersystolen (homotope und homotype Systolen) In Festschr. Feier. lOjahr. Besteh. Akad. prakt. Med. Coin, Bonn, 1915, 368-74, pl—Herkel, W., & Niirm- berger, W. Ueber mechanische und elektrische Svstolendauer. Verh. Deut. Ges. Kreislaufforsch., 1939, 12: 143-51.—Jordan, H. J., & Willems, H. P. A. Ueber die Bedeutung der Dehnung fur die Auslosung der Systole und demnach fur dis Koordina- tion des Helixherzens. Acta brevia ne,?rl, 1932, 2: 2.— I.ian, C, & Baraige, E. L'allongemente et le raccourcissement de la systole ventriculaire; son diagnostic k l'aide de la con- stante systolo-diastolique; sa valeur sdmdiologique. In Libro de oro M. R. Castex, B. Air., 1938, 2: 831-5. ------& Golblin, V. La constante systolo-diastolique (durde respective de la systole et de la diastoh) valeur sdmdiologique de l'allongement et du raccourcissement relatifs de la durde de la systole ventricu- laire. C. rend. Soc. biol, 1934, 115:962-4. ------ Diagnostic et valeur sdmdiologique de 1'allongement et du raccourcisse- ment de la systole ventriculaire; la constante svstolo-diasto- lique. Presse mdd., 1934, 42: 787-9 — Lombard, W. P., & Cope, O. M. The duration of the systole of the left ventricle of man. Am. J. Physiol, 1926, 87: 263-95. ------ Sex- differences in heart action; duration of svstole. Ibid., 1927, 83: 37-41.—Lutemb icher, R. Svstole annulaire pdristaltique. Arch. mal. coeur, 1938, 31: 513-7.—Mayeda, I. On the time relation between the systolic duration of the heart and the pulse rate. Acta Scholae med. Univ. Kioto, 1934, 17: 53-5 — Morelli, A. C. Las expansiones sist61icas a nivel de los ven- tricule* de coraz6n. Rev. argent, card., 1938, 5: 97-109.— HEART FUNCTION 303 HEART FUNCTION Panourgiag, B., & Routier, D. La durde de i'intervalle q-t, Rvstole dlectrique cardiaque, est-elle influencde par le volume du coeur? Arch. mal. coeur, 1939, 32: 386-92 [Discussion] 430_2__Periti, E. Lo svuotamento sistolico del cuore non d fisiolceicament'e completo; deduzioni di fisiopatologia del miocafdio Cuore & circol, 1932, 16: 602-13. Also Atti Soc med chir. Padova, 1933, ser. 2., 11: 25-8.—Romeuf. Travail du cceur; eusystolie. Gaz. mdd. France, 1934, 624-7.— Schirosa, G. Ricerche sul valore diagnostico e prognostico dell'allungamento della sistole. Riforma med., 1937, 53: 1583-5—Schlomka, G., & Raab, W. Zur Bewertung der relativen Systolendauer; iiber die Abhangigkeit der relativen Svstolendauer des Gesunden vom Lebensalter. Zschr. Kreis- laufforsch., 1936, 28: 673-701.—Schlomka, G., & Witzenrath, W. Zur Bewertung der relativen Systolendauer; iiber das Verhalten der relativen Systolendauer bei negativem T. Ibid. 1938, 30: 281-9.—Sebastiani, A. Une nouvelle formule nour' prdvoir la durde normale de la systole ventriculaire. Arch. mal. coeur, 1938, 31: 973-84.—Shannon, E. W., & Wiggers, C. J. The dynamics of the frog and turtle hearts; the nonr'efractory phase of systole. Am. J. Physiol, 1939-40, 128: 709-15.—Viti, V. P. Studio comparative per le formule fran'cesi di eusistolia e coefficiente funzionale circolatorio ed il fenomeno Livierato-Viti in soggetti alienati e sani di mente. Neopsichiatria, Pisa, 1938, 4: 256-70. --- Cardiac output. See also under Blood circulation. Maisonnetjve, P. *Le debit cardiaque en clinique. lOOp. 25^cm. Lyon, 1939. Zeitzer, O. *Der Anted der verschiedenen Organe an dem Minutenvolumen. 16p. 21cm. [Munch.] 1937. Aizawa, T. Klinische Beobachtung iiber das Minuten- vclumen. Jap. J. M. Sc, 1938-39, 5: Proc. Int. Med., 225 — Cordier, Enselme & Nury. Recherches sur les dchanges respiratoires et le ddbit cardiaque; dtude critique sur le ddbit cardiaque. Lyon mdd., 1937, 159: 67-73.—Giordano, C, & Gambigliani-Zoccoli, A. Contributo alio studio della portata cardiaca dal punto di vista teorico e sperimentale. Arch. sc. med., Tor., 1938, .66: 73-108.—Goldbloom, A. A. CUnical studies in circulatory adjustments; clinical evaluation of cardiac output studies. Internat. CUn., 1936, 46. ser., 3: 206-45, 3 pl—King, J. T., jr. The normal heart; its output and the circulatorv rate. In Diagn. Treat. Cardiovasc. Dis. (Stroud, W. D.) 'Phila., 1940, 1: 472-91— Kisch, B. Der gesamte und der zirkulierende Blutauswurf einer Herzab- teilung. Verh. Deut. Ges. Kreislaufforsch., 1930, 3: 114-26 — Lequime, J. Le ddbit cardiaque physiologique. Ann. sc. mdd. natur. BruxeUes, 1935, Bull, 149-75.—Marshall, E. K., jr. Studies on the cardiac output of the dog; the cardiac output of the normal unanesthetized dog. Am. J. Physiol, 1926, 77: 459-75.—Radnai, P. [Investigation of the systolic and minute volume of human heart] Orvoskdpzds, 1934, 24: 721-36 —Smolin, P. [Minute volume, its contour and clinical significance] Nowiny lek., 1937, 49: 284-91.—Steinmann, B. Schlagvolumen und Elektrokardiogramm. Helvet. med. acta, 1940-41, 7: 485-9.—Wulfovich, S. O., & Kukoverov, A. V. [Minute volume of rest in a normal individual] Tr. Acad. mil. mdd. Kiroff, 1935, 4: 145-53. --- Cardiac output: Measurement. See also under Blood circulation. Peter, H. *Ueber vergleichende Minuten- volumen-Bestimmungen [Freiburg] 40p. 8? 1932. Adams, W., & Sandiford, I. Variability and error in cardiac output estimation. Am. J. Physiol, 1940, 129: 297.—Bazett, H. C, Scott, J. C. [et al] Calculation of cardiac output from blood pressure measurements before and after meals. Ibid., 1936, 116: 551-62.—Binet, L., & Bouthillier, P. Le debit cardiaque; sa mesure chez I'homme par la mdthode k 1 lodure d'dthyle. Presse mdd., 1929, 37: 681-3.—Blair, H. A., & Wedd, A. M. The measurement in man by a pneumocardio- graphic method of the excess of arterial outflow from the chest over venous inflow during the heart cycle. Am. Heart J., 1939, 17: 536-41.—Blasius, W. Beitrag zur Schlagvo- lumenbestimmung aus den Blutdruckwerten. Zschr. Kreis- laufforsch., 1941, 33: 201-8— Biiger, A., & Wezler, K. Zur phvsikalischen Bestimmung absoluter Werte des Schlag- und Minutenvolumens des Herzens beim Menschen. Arch. exp. Path, Berl, 1936-37, 184: 253-75—Borgard, W, & Mat- thiessen, G. Beitrag zur Bestimmung des Herzminuten- volumens. Zschr. ges. exp. Med, 1936-37, 100: 374-7 — Christensen, E. H, Trolle, C, & Nielsen, H. E. Beitrage zur Physiologie schwerer korperlicher Arbeit; uber die Ver- suchsdauer bei Minutenvolumenbestimmungen mit der Acetylenmethode wahrend korperlicher Arbeit. Arbeits- phvsiologie, 1933, 7: 108-19.—Cooke, A. M.. & Priestley, J- G. Measurement of the cardiac output in man. J. Physiol, Lond, 1937, 90: 104-12—Cox, W. V, Hawkins, J. W., & Robertson. H. F. A method of estimating both basal and exercise cardiac output on dogs. J. Lab. Chn. M, 1935 3b, 21: 192-206 —Cullis, W. C, Rendel, O, & Dahl, E. Observa- tions on the ethyl iodide method for the determination of heart output. J. Physiol, Lond, 1927-28, 64: 39-46 — Dautrebande, L. La mesure du ddbit cardiaque: ses enseigne- ments cliniques. Bruxelles mdd, 1928, 8: 938-43. Les mdthodes de ddtermination du ddbit cardiaque chez I'homme. Mddecine, Par, 1930, 11: 182-9.—Delore, P., & Cadi, A. A propos du ddbit cardiaque; dtat actuel et valeur clinique de la mdthode. Lyon med, 1927, 140: 385-96.— Deppe, B, & Wetterer, E. Vergleichende tierexperimentelle Untersuchungen zur physikalischen Schlagvolumbestimmung. Zschr. Biol, 1938-39, 99: 307; 320.—Donal. J. S, jr. A convenient method for the determination of the approximate cardiac output in man. Am. J. Physiol, 1936, 116: 35. Also J. CUn. Invest, 1937, 16: 879-87.------& Gamble, C. J. The cardiac output in man; changes in alveolar oxygen and carbon dioxide tensions during rebreathing and the bearing of these upon the triple extrapolation method of estimating cardiac output. Am. J. Physiol, 1936, 116: 495-504 — Dulbecco, R, & Palomba, G. Osservazioni su di una curva di volume del cuore umano: il pletismodiagramma. Cuore & circol, 1938, 22: 86; 153.—Duomarco, J. El tiempo de evacua- cion ventricular por minuto; su determinaci6n electrocardio- grafica v su significacion fisio-patologica. Prensa mdd. argent, 1936, 23: 1682-94.—Espersen, T. Modified acetylene method for determination of the cardiac output and related circulatory functions, based on recent views of the ventilation of the lungs. Acta med. scand, 1941, 106: 108-28.—Gladstone, S. A. The factor of recirculation in acetylene method for determina- tion of cardiac output. Proc. Soc. Exp. Biol, N. Y.. 1934-35, 32: 1319-21.—Grollrrtan, A. The determination of the cardiac output of man by the use of acetylene. Am. J. Physiol, 1929, 88: 432-45.----—• A comparison of the triple extra- nolation (Fick principle) and the acetylene (forei™ gas princi- ple) methods for the determination of the cardiac output of man. Ibid, 1930, 93: 116-23.—Hamilton, W. F, Spradlin, M. C, & Saam, H. G., jr. An inauiry into the basis of the acetylene method of determining the cardiac output. Ibid. 1932, 100: 587-93.—Harris, I. A method of estimating cardiac output. Brit. M. J, 1927, 1: 510—Ivanovfky, B. D. [De- termination of systolic volume by Bremser's and Ranke's methods] Tr. Acad. mil. mdd. Kiroff, 1935, 4: 133-44.— Johnson, S. E. Roentgen kymography considered in relation to heart output, and a new heart index. Am. J. Roentg, 1937, 37: 167-74.—Kaup, J, & Grosse, A. Kreislauf-Minuton- volumen und Schlagvolumen nach der Peripherie-Herz- Atem-Koppehtngsregel. Klin. Wschr, 1937, 16: 1201; 1233 — Keys, A., & Friedell, H. L. Measurement of the stroke volume of the human heart from roentgenograms; simultaneous roentgenkvmographic and acetylene-rebreathing experiments. Am. J. Physiol, 1939, 128: 741-52. Also Proc. Soc. Exp. Biol, N. Y, 1939, 40: 554-6.—Khrenov, I, & Dobrykh, V. Certain improvements in the evaluation of basal metabolism] and minute volume of the heart] J. Physiol. LSSR, 1940, 29: 571-5.—Kudenko, M. V, & Kuleshov, D. S. [Simple method of indirect oscillographic determination of the minute volume of the heart] Ter. arkh, 1938, 16: No. 1-2, 60-73.—Lehmann, G. Zur Bestimmung des Herzschlagvolumens mit Aethyljodid. Arbeitsrhysiologie, 1928-29, 1: 114-29.—Lemort, A. Etude de la ddtermination du debit cardiaque, d'apres la mdthode de Meakins et Davies. Arch, internat. mSd. exp, Lidge, 1929-30, 5: 585-612. Also C. rend. Soc. biol, 1930, 103: 40-2 — Levy, S. E, & Blalock, A. Fractionation of the output of the heart and of the oxygen consumption of normal unanesthetixed dogs. Am. J. PhvsioL, 1937, 118: 368-71.—Manburg, E. M. [Clinical significance of estimation of the cardiac minute volume] In Kardiol. sess, Odessa, 1935, 1. Congr, 35 — Matthes, H. V. Die gasana-lytische und physikahsche Schlag- volumenbestimmung bei Rtihe und Arbeit. Arbeitsphysiologie, 1938-39, 10: 668-79.—Meshchinsky, E. B. [Non-msrcunal apparatus for obtaining air samples in examination of minute heart volume] Klin, med, Moskva, 1940, 18: No. 7, 139-41 — Meyer, F. Nomogramm zur Berechnung des arten^llen Windk'essels und des Herzschlagvolumens. Klin. Wschr, 1938, 17: 1647-9.—Mobitz, W. Ergebnisse von 200 Herz- schla'gvolumbestimmungen beim Menschen. Verh. Deut. Ges inn Med, 1926, 38. Kongr, 314. ------ Die Ermittlung des Herzschlagvolumens des Menschen durch Einatmung von Aethvljcdid. Klin. Wschr, 1926, 5: 985.---— & Grosse, A. Die Ermittelung des Herzschlagvolumen des Menschen durch Einatmung von Aethyljodiddampf. Arch. exp. Path, Lpz, 1926 118: 192-210.—Mobitz. W., & Hin^berg, K. Die Ermittlung des Herzschlasrvolumens des Menschen durch Einatmung von Aethyljodiddampf; weitere Untersuchungen iiber die Grundlagen der Methodik. Ibid, 1927, 123: 282 9 — Neukirch, F. Comparative examinations on the cardiac output in man, determined partly by the acetylene method partly by the reduced blood-pressure amplitude multujed bv the pulse rate. Acta med. scand, 1936, Suppl. 78, 519 £4. Nielsen, E. Some remarks on determination of the minute volume in normal persons and heart patients. Ibid, 525-38. Nikisin, F. [Determination of minute-volume of the heart in man; puncture of the right ventricle] Cas ldk. desk, 1931 70: 1230-2.—Noyons, A. K. M. Erne neue Methode zur Messung des Schlag- und Minutenvolumens des Herzens. Proc In- ternat PhvsioL Congr. (1935) 1938, 15 Con<;r. 433.-Scott !i C ?Bazett, H. C. [et al] The validity of the Grollman method for caidiac outputs above the basal value. Am J. Physiol, 1935 113: 118.—Shick, J. L. [Determination of the beat and minute blood volume by means of roentgenokymography] Klin, med, Moskva, 1940, 18: No. 7, 60-7.—Snyder, J. C. HEART FUNCTION 304 HEART FUNCTION The determination of the cardiac output in man at brief intervals by a modification of the etlnl iodide method. J. Clin. Invest, 1938, 17: 563-9—Sundberg. C. G. Leber die Bedingungen zur rontgenologisehen Bestimmung des Schlag- volumeTi.- des llei/ens. L'psala lak. foren. forh, 1030, 45: 71 80- Thauer. Zur experimentellen Sicherung der phvsi- kalischen Schlagvulunil e.-tiiiunungsmethoden. Zschr. Kreis- laufforsch, 1941, 33: 37S.- Wezler, K., & Biiger, A. Ueber einen neuen Weg zur Rotiminung des absoluten Schlag- volumens des Herzens beim Menschen auf Grund der Wind- kesseltheorie und seine experimentelle Prufung. Arch. exp. Path, Berl, 1936-37, 184: 4*2-505.—Yasaki, S. A new method of estimating the cardiac output of man. Jap. J. M. Sc, 1939-40, 6: Proc. Biophysics, 116. ---- Cardiac output: Variation. Abioht, E. *Ueber die Beziehungen zwischen Frequrnz und Minutenvolumen am isolierten Froschherzen [Berlin] 27p. 8? Burg-M., 1934. Buchsel, M. *Herzschlag- und Minuten- volumen des Gesunden im Liegen und Stehen [Miinchen] 16p. 22cm. Wiirzb., 1938. Meyer, G. *Minutenvolumen und arterieller Blutdruck. 43p. 8? Miinch., 1937. Nury, D. Contribution a l'etude du debit cardiaque et des echanges respiratoires. 24(>p. 8? Trevoux, 1936. Schulz, F. *ITeber den Zusammenhang zwischen dem Schhigvolumen des Herzens und der Dauer der Q-R-S-Schwankung im Elektro- kardiogramm [Heidelberg] 14p. 8? Danzig, 193fi. Asmussen, E. The cardiac output in rest and work in humid heat. Am. .1. Physiol, 1940-41, 131: 54-9.—Blalork, A, & Harrison, T. R. Oxygen lack and cardiac output; some clinical consociations. J. Am. M. Ass, 1926, 87: 1984-7. ------ The regulation of circulation; the effect of anemia and hemorrhage on the cardiac output of dogs. Am. J. Physiol, Bait, 1927, 80: 157-68. ------ The effects of severe anoxemia of short duiatimi on the cardiac output of morphinized dogs and tiained unnarcotized dogs. Ibid, 169-78.—Gahoon, I). IL. Johnson, V, & Michael, I. E. Respiratory modification of the cardiac output. Ibid.. 1940, 129: 326— Cordier, V, Enselme, J, cV: Nury, I). Heche i dies .-ui les eeliaiurcs respira- toires et le ddbit caidia/2cm. Santiago, 1940. Kaufmann, E. *Die Bedeutung der Atmung fiir die Suffizienz des Herzens und eine klinische Methode zu ihrer Beurteilung. 31p. 21}£cm. Bonn, 1926. Koby, F. *Ueber die Beziehungen zwischen Herzrythmus und Atmung [Basel] 42p. 8°. Arlesheim, 1917. Amar, J. Adaptation respiratoire du cceur. C. rend. Acad. sc, 1929, 189: 1201-3.—Bassani, B. Influences du foie sur la fonction cardiaque. Arch. ital. biol, 1933-34, 90: 26-32, 2 pl.—Bohme, W. Ueber zwei neue, von der Respiration abhangige, klinisch erfassbare, rontgenologisch geklarte Herz- phanomene. Fortsch. Roentgenstrahl, 1937, 55: 107-17.— Braun-Menendez, E., & Vedoya, R. Les mouvements cardio- pneumatiques. C. rend. Soc. biol, 1937, 124: 377-80.— Frey, E. K. Zusammenhange zwischen Herzarbeit und Nie- rentatigkeit. Arch. klin. Chir, 1926, 142: 663-9.—Friedrich, L. Ist die Herztatigkeit vom Magen-Darm aus beeinflussbar? Arch. Verdauungskr, 1936, 60: 67-71.—Haufle, G. Die Abhangigkeit der Herztatigkeit von der Einstellung der Ge- fasslichtung. Virchows Arch., 1932, 286: 780-810—Heymans, C. Relation between circulation and respiration. Cas. U'k, desk, 1936, 75: 705-10.—01 irsch, E. Der Einfluss der Atmung auf die Herztatigkeit. Zbl. Herz Gefasskr, 1926, 18: 112-5.— Holzlohner, E. Die Volumenanderungen im menschlichen Thorax wahrend der Herzaktion. Zschr. Biol, 1931-32, 92: 293-316.—Kahn, M. H. The influence of venous filling on the heart. Ann. Int. M, 1929-30, 3: 909-90.—Martino, G. Sulle modificazioni dell'attiviti cardiaca per effetto di stimo- lazioni del t rat to gastroent rico. Boll. Soc. biol. sper, 1926, 1: 390-3.- Muller, E. A. Die Anpassung des Herzvolumens an den Aortendruck. Arch. ges. Physiol, 1938-39, 241: 427-38.— Paillard, H. Quelques relations fonctionnelles entre le coeur HEART FUNCTION 305 HEART FUNCTION et le poumon: arythymie respiratoire, influence de la toux sur la circulation; dpreuve de Valsalva et insuffisance cardiaque; action de la respiration profonde sur l'hypertension arterielle. I mdd fr 1933, 22: 48-51.—Robinson, G. C. The respiratory svstem with special reference to the heart and the internal ration. Tr. Ass. Am. Physicians, 1924, 39: 44-51.- Rumpf Der Einfluss der Atmung auf die Herztatigkeit. Zbl Herz Gefiisskr, 1926, 18: 315-7.—Somer, E. de. Re- cherches sur les modifications que subit la respiration par des variations cardiaques; relations cardio-respiratoires. J. physiol path, gdn, 1930, 28: 311-20. ■----- Rapport des courbes respiratoires du coeur avec le synchronisme pneumo- cardiaque chez le chien. Bull. Acad, mdd. Par, 1937, 3. ser, 117- 77-83.—Tail, J, & Berrill, N. J. Svncronism of heart and'respiratory beat in Limulus. Am. J. Physiol., 1936, 116: 153. --- Development. Rotjmain, L. *Examens electrocardiogra- phiques chez les nouveaux-nes pendant les premiers jours de la vie [Lyon] 29p. 8? Vienne, 1936. Alexander, R. S, & Glaser, O. Progressive acceleration in embryonic hearts. J. Exp. Zool, 1941, 87: 17-30.—Armstrong, P. B. Functional reactions in the embryonic heart accompany- ing the ingrowth and development of the vagus innervation. Ibid, 1931, 58: 43-61, 3 pl.—Arvanitaki, A, & Cardot, H. L'dlectrogramme des lambeaux ventriculaires de l'escargot et son dvolution. C. rend. Soc. biol, 1932, 111: 986-8.—Barcroft, J Flexner, L. B, & McClurkin, T. The output of the foetal heart in the goat J. Physiol, Lond, 1934, 82: 498-508 — Bremer. J. L. The presence and influence of 2 spiral streams in the heart of the chick embryo. Am. J. Anat, 1932, 49: 409-40. ------ Circulatory disturbances in operated chick embryos: reversal of heart beat. Anat. Rec, 1932, 51: 275- g4 —Corey, E. L. Fetal and early post-natal cardiac activity in the rat. Am. J. Physiol, 1935, 113: 30. ------ Observa- tions on cardiac activity in the fetal rat. J. Exp. Zool, 1935, 72- 127-45, 3 pl—Davie, J. H. Functional evolution of a heart. Hahneman. Month, 1940, 75: 666-72—Dwinnell, L A. Physiological contraction of double hearts in rabbit embrvos. Proc. Soc. Exp. Biol, N. Y, 1939, 42: 264-7.— Easby, M. H. Electrocardiograms from a tyi months old fetus. Am. Heart J, 1934, 10: 118.—Enikeeva, S. I. [Lability of the heart (limit of rhythm adaptation in its ontogenesis] J. Physiol. USSR, 1941, 30: 331-8—Ermakov, M. V. [Evolu- tion of functions; evolution of the heart and its activity] .1 mdd, Kiev, 1937, 7: 545-64.—Franklin, K. J. Foetal circu- lation in right atrium. Brit. M. J, 1940, 2: 506.—Heard, J. D., Burkley, G. G, & Schaefer, C. R. The electrocardio- grams derived from 11 fetuses through the medium of direct leads. Tr. Ass. Am. Physicians, 1935, 50: 335-41. Also Am. Heart J, 1936, 11: 41-8. Also repr.—His, W., jr. The func- tion of the embryonic heart and its significance in the interpre- tation of the heart action in the adult, transl. by F. A. Wlilliusl In Cardiac Classics (Willius, F. A.) S. Louis, 1941, 695 — Hoff, E., DuBois, D. [et al] The development of the electro- cardiogram of the embryonic heart. Univ. Hosp. Bull, Ann Arb, 1939, 5: 25.—Hoff, E. C, Kramer, T. C. [et al] The development of the electrocardiogram of the embryonic heart. Am. Heart J, 1939,17:470-88.—Hori, H, Imai, M, & Sato, M. On the electrocardiogram of the normal new-born. Jap. J. Obst, 1935, 18: 325-32.—Johnson, A. S. An unexpected electrocardiogram of the fetus. J. Am. M. Ass, 1938, 111: 916-8.—Jones, F. W. Development and function. Mel- bourne Hosp. Chn. Rep, 1930, 1: 132.—Kellogg, H. B. The course of the blood flow through the fetal mammalian heart. Am. J. Anat, 1928, 42: 443-65.—Lueg, W., & Hofer, K. Elektrokardiogramme von embryonalen Hiihnerherzen in der Gewebskultur bei gleichzeitiger Kinematographie des Be- wegungsablaufs. Deut. med. Wschr, 1933, 59: 452.—Lukino- vi6, J. Zur Frage der Herztatigkeit bei jungen menschlichen Embryonen. Zbl. Gyn, 1937, 61: 2912-4.—Magruder, S. R. The course of the blood through the heart of the chick embryo during late embryonic life. Anat. Rec, 1932, 54: 137-48.— Mann, H, & Bernstein, P. Fetal electrocardiography. Am. Heart J, 1941, 22: 390-400.—Mayeda, I. The establishment of the adult type of electrocardiogram after parturition in rabbits. Acta Scholae med. Univ. Kioto, 1934, 17: 50-2 — Nasu, M. Beitrage zum Studium des Elektrokardiogrammes beim Huhnerembryo. Jap. J. M. Sc, 1939-40, 6: Proc. Biophysics, 115.—Olivo, O. M. Attivite funzionale e accre- scimento del cuore embrionale. Boll. Soc. ital. biol. sper, 1933,8:6. Also repr.—Patten, B. M. Changes with age in embryonic heart action as recorded in micromoving pictures. J. Am. M. Ass, 1941, 116: 2529.—Rech, W. Experimentelle Untersuchungen iiber Beziehungen zwischen mutterlicher und kindlicher Herzaktion. Arch. Gyn., Berl, 1927, 132: 57-9 [Discussion] 63-7. ------ Experimentelle Untersuchungen iiber die Beeinflussung der fetalen Herztatigkeit. Ibid, 1930- 31, 144: 564-6 [Discussion] 567.—Siedentopf, H. Die Mog- lichkeit der therapeutischen intrauterinen Beeinflussung der kindlichen Herzaktion. Zbl. Gyn, 1928, 52: 3122-33 — Steffan, H, & Strassmann, E. Das fetale Elektrokardiogramm. Ibid, 1933, 57: 610-5. Also repr.—Strassmann, E. O. The fetal electrocardiogram late in pregnancy. Proc Mayo Clin, 1936, 11: 778-82. & Mussey, R. D. Technic and results of routine fetal electrocardiography during pregnancy Am. J. Obst, 1938, 36: 986-97.—Tschermak, A. Zur Physio- logie des embryonalen Herzens. Med. Klin, Berl, 1927, 23: 1776-8.—Windle, W. F. Circulation of blood through the fetal heart and lungs and changes occurring with respiration at birth. Q. Bull. Northwest. Univ. M. School, 1940, 14: 31-6. ------& Becker, R. F. The course of the blood through the fetal heart; an experimental study in the cat and guinea pig. Anat. Rec, 1940, 77: 417-26. ---- Dynamics [and efficiency] Avaritsiotis, E. L'oscillomdtrie en tant que dynamomdtrie cardiaque. Bull, mdd. Par, 1926, 40: 701-16.—Banuelos Garcia, D. M. Estudios sobre din&mica cardiaca. Siglo mdd, 1918, 65: 611; passim.—Biihme, W. Neuere rontgenologische Ergebnisse; aktive Forderung des Blutriickstroms durch das Herz; mit rontgenkinematographischer Demonstration. Aerztl Fortbild. Bad Nauheim, 1938, 14: 149-60.—Henderson, Y. On the efficiency of the heart and its management. Lancet, Lond, 1925, 2: 1265; 1317.—Katz, L. N, Jochim, K. [et al.] The effect of varying resistance-load and input-load on the energetics of the surviving mammalian heart. Am. J. Physiol, 1941, 134: 636-44.—Knipping, H. W. Ueber die Kontrolle der Herzleistungsgrenze (Grenzwert des Herzminutenvolumens) in der Klinik. Deut. med. Wschr, 1937, 63: 462-4.—Leuken, B. Die Dynamik des einzelnen Herzschlags. Med. Welt, 1936, 10: 1289-91.—Meczner, L. [Working quotient of heart beat] Orv. hetil, 1932, 76: 792-5.—Moe, G K, Wood, E H, & Visscher, M. B. Aortic pressure and the diastolic volume; law of energy output in cardiac contraction. Proc. Soc. Exp. Biol, N. Y, 1939, 40: 460-3—Netousek, M. [Cardiological aspects from the dynamic viewpoint] Bratisl. lek. listy, 1936, 16: 551-61.—Pruche, A. Comment ddterminer la valeur fonctionnelle du coeur; le cardio-dynamomdtre. Bull. Soc. mdd. Paris, 1936, 141-7. ------ Les applications cliniques du dynamomdtrie cardiaque. Ibid, 264-7.------ La valeur fonctionnelle du coeur, la cardiodvnamomdtrie. Arch. mal. coeur, 1937, 3Q: 889; 1938, 31: 93.—Scheinfinkel, N. Methoden zur Untersuchung der Dynamik des Froschherzens. In Handb. biol. Arbeitsmeth. (Abderhalden, E.) 1935, Abt. V. T. 8, 1051-71.—Schrotter, H. von, & Lowy, A Ergebnisse von Versuchen zur Bestimmung der Blutgasspannungen und der Herzarbeit am Menschen. Mitt. Ges. inn. Med. Kinderh, 1904, 3: 235-7.—Starling, E. H., & Visscher, M. B. The regu- lation of the energy output of the heart. J. Physiol, Lond, 1926-27, 62: 243-61.—Starr, I, jr, Collins, L. H, jr, & Wood, F. C. Studies of the basal work and output of the heart in cUnical conditions. J. Clin. Invest, 1933, 12: 13-43.—Stern, N. S. Heart load. South. M. J, 1927, 20: 355-7.—Treadgold, H. A. Cardiac functional efficiency in the young male adult. Proc. R. Soc. M, Lond, 1929-30, 23: Sect. War, 7-13. Also J. R. Nav. M. Serv, 1930, 16: 161-9.—Ulrich, J. Die Herz- kraft und wie sie einfach registriert und gemessen werden kann. Munch, med. Wschr, 1939, 86: 455.—Wiggers, C. J. The dominant control of mammalian ventricular dynamics by initial length. Rev. Soc. argent, biol, 1934, 10: Suppl, 546-54. ------ & Katz, L. N. The static and dynamic effort of the heart during ejection. Am. J. Physiol, 1928, 85: 229-50. ---- Dynamics: Reserve power. Giordano, S. *A symposium on the deter- mination of cardiac reserve [All Souls Hosp.] MS. 9p. 28 cm. Morristown. 1940. Bethea, O. W. Determination of cardiac reserve. Internat. M. Digest, 1939, 35: 115-8—Betocchi, G. La pressione ar- teriosa nei metodi di valutazione della forza di riserva del cuore. Rass. med. lavoro indust, 1933, 4: 559-74.—Caldwell, H. Mechanical aids in estimating cardiac reserve. J. Florida M. Ass, 1926-27, 13: 261-3.—Gammon, J. E. The estimation of heart reserve. Ibid, 126-30.—Hyman, A. S. A pump test for functional reserve of the heart; a combined cardiodynamom- eter and accessory blood pressure air tank. N. England J. M 1930, 202: 807-9.—Kevdin, N. A. [Cardiac reserve force (Schwann-Starling) Russ. klin, 1926, 6: 25-37.—Nikolaev, G. N. [Vital capacity of the heart] Vrach. delo, 1936, 19: 585-8 —Offergeld. Zur Beurteilung der Reservekraft des Herzens. Deut. Zschr. Chir, 1927, 202: 304-24.—Stroud, W. D. The importance and the most satisfactory clinical methods of estimating the myocardial reserve. Am. Heart J, 1925-26, 1: 354-8.—Wolfer, P. Reservekraft und Funktion des normalen und pathologischen Herzens. Schweiz. med. Wschr, 1935, 65: 829-34. ---- electric. See Electrocardiogram. — Examination. See also subheading Test. American Heart Association. Committee on Leaflets and Pamphlets. Examination of the heart. lOp. 21J/2cm. N. Y. [1940] 227475—vol. 7, 4th series- -20 HEART FUNCTION 306 HEART FUNCTION Taqlini, A. C. Exploraci6n del coraz6n por via esofagica. 231p. 23cm. B. Air., 193<>. Anderson, \V. N. Physical examination of the heart. Med. Clin. N. America, 1928, 12: 339-51.—Dumas, A. L'intdrct de la courbe oseillomdtrique pour l'apprdciation des diltercntes phases de hi rdvolution cardiaque. J. mdd. Lyon. 1033. 14: 559-04.—Faulkner. J. M. Examination of the heart in general practice. Med. Clin X. America, 1939, 23: 1291-305.— Gordon, W. The practical importance of posture in the physical examination of the heart, with some remarks on stethoscopes. Clin. J, Lond, 1926, 55: 193-6.—Gramenizki, M. I. Einige Methoden zur Beobachtung der Tatigkeit des Froschherzens. In Handb. biol. Arbeitsmeth. (Abderhalden. E.) 1935, Abt. V, T. 8, 953-63—McCunn. J. The clinical examination of the heart. Vet. Rec. Lond, 1939, 51: 341-.>1. Also Rev. m ificance cf osci'lo- graphy] Ter. arkh, 1936, 14: 30-1-407.—Mann, H. The monocardiograph. Am.Heart J, 193S, 15: 6S1-99.—Morelli, A. C. Tvouvel oscillographe pour cardiulogie et physiologie. C. rend. Soc. biol, 1932, 111: 537- Rijbrt, P. Technique de ICxplorat on oscillographique du coeur chez I'homme. Ibid, 1935. 119: 1185.—Strauss, S, & Weisglapp, L. Apparatus for measuring and supervising the heart action. L. S. Patent Off, 1940, No. 2,193,945.— Tsamboulas, N. Spirograph ische Kontrolle der Herztatigkeit. Deut. med. Wschr, 1936, 62: 1908-12. ---- Graphic registration. See also Electrocardiography; Heartbeat, &c. Ohias, O. Registro e interpretaci6n de la actividad cardiaca. 3. ed. 199p. 23cm. B. Air., 1939. Nuki, B, & Omura, H. Leber eine Herzaktion registrie- rende Methode beim in-situ-Versuch am Kaninchen. Jap. J. M. Sc, 1937, 10: Proc. Pharm, 9.—Osborn, D. P., & Fath, A. F. The graphic registration of the normal heart action. J. Med, Cincin, 1941-42, 22: 5-20.—Tey, A, & Audap- Soubie, P. Llectrocardiomiograma. Prensa mdd. argent, 1938. 25: 1290 5.—Vastesaeger, M. M, & Schnitz, P. E. La definition graphique du travail cardiaque. C. rend. Soc. biol, 1936, 122: 787-9. ---- Graphic registration: Ballistocardiography. Cournand, A, & Ranges, H. A. Determination of cardiac output in man by the direct Fick method and the ballisto- eardiogiaph. Am. J. Physiol, 1941, 133: 251.—Dow, P, & Hamilton, W. F. An analysis, by hydraulic models, of the factors operating to produce the typical ballistocardiogram. Ibid, 263.------ Cardiac and aortic contributions to the human ballistocardiogram. Ibid, 313.—Starr, I, & Rawson, A. J. The vertical ballistocardiograph; experiments on the changes in the circulation on arising; with a further study of ballistic theory. Ibid, 134: 403-25.—Starr, I, Rawson, A. J. [et al] Studies on the estimation of cardiac output in man, and of abnormalities in cardiac function, from the heart's recoil and the blood's impacts; the ballistocardiogram. Ibid, 1939, 127: 1-28.—Starr, I.. & Schroeder, H. A. Ballisto- cardiogram; normal standards, abnormalities commonly found in diseases of the heart and circulation, and their significance. J. Clin. Invest, 1940, 19: 437-50. ---- Mechanics. Buchem, F. S. P. van. *De venapols en naar aanleiding daarvan eenige beschouwingen over het hartmechanisme. 96p. 8? Leiden, 1924. Barcroft. H. Observations on the pumping action of the heart. J. PhysioL, Lond, 1933, 78: 186-95.—Guthrie, C. C. Functional heart mechanisms. Proc. Soc. Exp. Biol, N. ^ , 1933, 30: 946 9. Hauffe, G. Wie wnken die Hilfskriifte der als Saug- und I >i uckpunipe arboitcnden Herzmasch ne'.' Virchows Arch, 1927, 2tib: 18-50. --Havlicek, H. Arbeitet das Herz wie cine 1 )ruckpumpe oder wie ein Stosshebei■'.' eine neue Herzthcoi ie. Arch. Kreislaufforsch, 1937, 1: 188-224. ------ [Does the heart work as a pressure pump or hydraulic ram?] Polska gaz. lek, 1937, 16: 41-3.—Ozolen Akil Moukhtar. De la force aspiratrice du coeur et de son importance, au point de vue de la pharmacodynamic et de la clinique. Bull. Acad, mdd. Par, 1936, 3. ser, 115: 753-63 — Peter, J. [On Havlicek's article, on the heart being com paired to Montgolfier's apparatus] Polska gaz. lek, 1937, 16: 13 5.-- Pfuhl, W. Die Rolle der intrathorakalen Saugkraft bei der Erweiterung und Fullung des Herzens. Anat. Anz, 1929-30, 68: 47-64. ------ Der intrathorakale Sog und seine Wirkung auf das Herz. Ibid, 1931, 72: 11-23. ----- Der Ablauf der Herztatigkeit unter der Mitwirkung der intrathorakalen Saugkraft. Deut. Arch. klin. Med, 1936, 179: 247-67.—Schonholzer, G. Ablauf der Herzaktion und intrathorakaler Druck. Helvet. med. acta, 1040-41, 7: 4,H1 4.—Socha-Borzestowski, von. Hat der Ilerzbeutel Bezie- hungen zur Saugwirkung des Herzens? Fortsch. Med, 1927, 14: 175.—Steinmann, B. Klinische Lntersuchungen uber die Beziehungen zwischen mechanischer und elektrischer Herzak- tion. Klin. Wschr, 1941, 20: 259-64.—Stephens, G. A. Mechanical function of the heart. Brit. M. J, 1936, 2: 651. ---- Roentgen kymography. See also Heart, Radiography. Banda-Garkido, I. *R6ntgenphotographische Mossung des Herzens durch Stereokymographie. 24p. 8? Miinch., 1931. Dtjran Arrom. Quimograffa cardfaca en clinica; estudio especial de la cinematica del corazon en pacientes con onda T coronariana. 71p. 8? Villarreal, 1933. Also Siglo mdd, 1933, 92: 571; passim. Fischgold, H. *L'etude fonctionnelle du ccrur par la radiokymographie. 53p. 8? Par., 1933. Huber, G. *Die rontgenkymographische Untersuchung am gesunden Herzen mit be- sonderer Berucksichtigung des rechten Ventrikels. 18p. 8? Freib. i. B., 1933. Niederhuber, M. *Der rechte phrenico- cardiale Winkel im Flachenkymogramm [Miin- chen] 27p. 20}£cm. Giinzburg, 1937. Reckeweg, A. *Die Verwertung des Ampli- tuden-Frequenz-Produktes nach Korperarbeit als Funktionspriifung des Herzens. 32p. 8? Kiel, 1933. Schorr, H. *Ueber die Ursachen der unter hydrostatischer Druckwirkung am Herzront- genkymogramm auftretenden Veranderungen. 35p. 8? Bresl., 1938. Sirry, G. *Untersuchungen iiber die am rechten Ascendensrand vorkommenden Zacken- formen im Flachenkymogramm des Herzens und ihre Entstehung. 22p. 21cm. Miinch., 1938. Abreu, M. de. Die kymographische Beurteilung der Herztatigkeit. Fortsch Rontgenstrahl, 1939, 59: 91-120. Also In Libro de oro M. R. Castex, B. Air, 1938, 2: 1-41. ------ & Londres, G. Radiokymographia cardio-vascular. Brasil med, 1935, 49: 377; 424—Arendt, J., & Baumann, H. Grosse und Lagebestimmung der einzelnen Herzteile mittels des Flachenkymogramms in Ruhe und bei Arbeit. Klin. Wschr., 1931, 10: 1607-9.—Arkussky, U. I. [Characteristics of func- tion of the heart from the roentgenologic viewpoint] Vrach. gaz, 1930, 34: 116-20. Also Fortsch. Rontgenstrahl, 1930, 41: 714-31. ------ [Significance of kymography in cardiology] Vest, rentg, 1938, 20: 133-54.—Bascourret & Fischgold. Les variations de l'image kymographique cardiaque suivant la pdriode respiratoire. Arch. mal. coeur, 1938, 31: 87-93.— Bohme, W. [Physiologisch-rontgenologische Bewegungstu- dien uber die Herzphysiologie] Magy. rontg. kozl, 1939, 13: 85-91.------& Braunbehrens, H. von [Bewegungsstudien mit Hilfe moderner Rontgenverfahren an Herz und Kreislauf] Ibid, 109.—B0rge, F, & Kjaergaard, H. [Roentgen kymog- raphy of the heart in normal and pathologic states] Hos- pitalstidende, 1934, 77: (Jydsk. med. selsk. forh.) 66-89.— Braunbehrens, H. von [Die Stumpf'sche Flachenkymographie als registrierend diagnostisches Verfahren fur das menschliche Herz] Magy. rontg. kozl, 1939, 13: 110. ------ Ueber die Leistungen des Rontgenverfahrens fur die Herzfunktions- priifung. Verh. Deut. Ges. inn. Med, 1938, 50. Kongr, 97- 103.—Brednow, W., & Schaare, U. Kymographische Unter- suchungen des normalen Herzens. Zschr. klin. Med, 1933, HEART FUNCTION 3C 125: 480-92.—Burger, M. Rontgenologische Herzfunktions- nruf'ung Fortsch. Rontgenstrahl, 1939, 60: 78-92. Also Rontgenpraxis, 1939, 11: 436—Chamberlain, W. E., & Dock, W The study of the heart action with the Roentgen cinemato- graph. Radiology, 1926, 7: 185-9.—Cignolini, P. Metodi e mdte della chimografia cardiaca (roentgenchimografia cardiaca) Radiol, med, Milano, 1932, 19: 401-5. ---;--- Progressi nella roentgenchimografia cardiaca. Cuore & circol, 1933, 17: g73_5-----• Die Rotgenkymographie mit unterbro- chenem Schlitz. Fortsch. Rontgenstrahl, 1934, 49: 224-40. .----- Chimografia cardiaca: lo spostamento oblique. Radiol. med, Milano, 1934, 21: 166-70.—Cottenot, P. La radiographic' du cceur en systole et en diastole. Bull. Soc. mdd. hop. Paris, 1933, 3. ser, 49: 666-70. Also Bull. Soc. radiol. mdd. France, 1933, 21: 42-5. ------ Sdlecteur cardio-respiratoire; per- mett'ant la stdrdoradiographie thoracique et la prise de radio- graphics du cceur en systole et en diastole. J. radiol. electr, 1933, 17: 381-4. ------ & Heim de Balsac, R. Que peut-on penser actuellement de la kymographie appliquee a I'appareil cardio-vasculaire? Bull. Soc. mdd. Paris, 1934, 51-9.------ La kymographie cardiaque. Prat. mdd. fr, 1934, 15: 303-8. -----& Laubry, C. Etude kymographique du coeur normal. BuU. Soc. mdd. hop. Paris, 1933, 3. ser, 49: 867-79.—Delherm, L, Bordet. E. [et al] Etude sur les courbes radiokymogra- phiques de la rdvolution cardiaque. Arch. mal. coeur, 1933, 26: 653-84. ------ Epreuves fonctionnelles du coeur et radio- kymographie. Bull. Soc. mdd. hop. Paris, 1934, ser. 3, 50: 1339-42.------Courbes de radiokymographie de la rdvolu- tion cardiaque. Bull. Soc. radiol. mdd. France, 1933, 21: 651-60.—Delherm, L, Thoyer-Rozat. P, & Fischgold. Sur la ddtermination du point G et sur la radiographie du coeur en systole et en diastole. Ibid, 45-54. ■------ L'exploration fonctionnelle du coeur par la radiokymographie. J. radiol. dlectr, 1934, 18: 505-14.—De Meyer, J. Un appareil traceur d'abscisses et d'ordonndes pour les courbes kymographiques. Arch, internat. physiol, Lidge, 1913-14, 14: 373-82—Des- sauer & Kiipferle. Des radiogrammes des phases separees du mouvement du coeur. Arch, dlectr. mdd. exp, Bord, 1913, 22: 565-8.—Faber, B. Grundbegriffe der Kymographie des Herzens. Acta med. scand, 1936, Suppl. 78, 101-13. ------ & Kjaergaard, H. P. [Normal and pathological kymography of heart] Hospitalstidende, 1936, 79: [Dansk radiol. selsk. forh.] 72-5. Also Brit. J. Radiol, 1936, 9: 335-44—Farinas, P. L, & Aixal?, R. La radiokimografia cardiovascular. Arch. med. int., Habana, 1936, 2: 1-49, 2 ch.—Forfota, E. [Kymo- graphia a rontgendiagnostikaban] Magy. rontg. kozl, 1935, 9: 63-76.—Gillies, C. L, & Kerr, H. D. Roentgen kymog- raphy of the heart and great vessels. Am. J. Roentg, 1936, 35: 640-4.—Gin^burg, V. G. [Modification of the roentgeno- kvmograph by Ciniollini] Ter. arkh, 1935,13:103.—Golonzko, R. A. [Effect of movement interference on the kymographie curve of the heart] Klin, med, Moskva, 1938, 16: 629-32, pl.—Gonzalez Sabathie, L, & Codino, S. Roentgenkimografia cardiovascular. Dia mdd, B. Air, 1934-35, 7: 497-9. ;----- Cardio-radiologia; radiografias de corazon en sistole y diastole. In Temas cardiol. (Gonzalez Sabathid, L.) B. Air, 1935, 4 : 185-97.—Greenebaum, J. V., Brown, S, & Selkirk, T. Roent- gen kymography in the studv of the heart in childhood. Ohio M. J, 1940, 36: 1194-7.—Groedel, F. M. Die technische Vervollkommnung der Rontgenkinematographie. Fortsch. Rontgenstrahl, 1929, 39: 15-7.—Gubner. R, Crawford, J. H. [et al] Roentgenkymography of the heart; its clinical applica- tions and limitations. Am. Heart J. 1939, 18: 729-46.— Gunsett, A, & Cornu, P. Les methodes de radiokymographie cardiaque. Bull. Soc radiol. mdd. France, 1935, 23: 217-27— Heckmann, K. Ueber Herzkymographie. Miinch. med. Wschr, 1935, 82: 1079-84. ------ Moderne Methoden zur Lntersuchung der Herzpulsation mittels Rontgenstrahlen. Erg. inn. Med. Kinderh, 1937, 52: 543-610—Hei=ig, W. Das Herzkymogramm in zwei Ebenen auf einem Film. Fortsch. Rontgenstrahl, 1938, 57: 187-9—Helstein, F. M. [Roent- genokymography of the heart] Ter. arkh, 1935, 13: No. 5, 3-20, 23 pl. ------ Ginsburg, V. G. [et al] [Clinical signif- icance of roentgeno-kymography of the heart] Ibid, 1934, 12: No. 3, 24-35, 16 pl.—Hirsch, I. S. The examination of the heart by the rontgenkymographie method. Brit. J. Radiol, 1934, 7: 728-54. ------ X-ray kymography of the heart' J. M. Soc. N. Jersey, 1938, 35: 167. ------ The recording of cardiac movements and sounds by the roentgen ray (kymo- phonoroentgenography) Radiology, 1934, 22: 403-22. ------ & Gubner, R. Application of roentgenkymography to the study of normal and abnormal cardiac physiology. Am. Heart J, 1936, 12: 413-34.—Hirsch, I. S, & Schwarzschild, M. The simultaneous recording of cardiac movements and sounds by the Roentgen ray (Kvmophonoroentgenography) Acta radiol, Stockh, 1934, 15: 101-6, pl—Hofman, S. [Roentgen kymography of the heart] Lijed. vjes, 1941, 63: 78-84.— Hoist, L Flachenkymograph oder Einschlitzkymograph. Fortsch. Rontgenstrahl, 1935, 51: 451-3. ------ Klioner. I. [et al] Die Flachenkymographie des Herzens. Ibid, 454-69.—Ihre, B. Rontgenkymography ad modum Stumpf as a method of examining the heart. Acta radiol, Stockh, 1934, 15: 107-24, 3 pl—Ismet. [Kymography of the heart] Askeri sihhiye mecmuasi, 1937, 66: 48-56—Iwasaki, H, & Shiga, T. "Ueber Rontgenkymographische Untersuchungen der Herztatigkeit. Jap. J. M. Sc, 1938-39, 5: Proc. Int. Med, 73. Also Fortsch. Rontgenstrahl, 1938, 58: 484-507.— Kalocsay, P. Verfahren zur fortlaufenden Aufnahme der I HEART FUNCTION Herztatigkeit mittels Rontgenstrahlen an beliebig gewahlten Einzelstellen des Herzens [vorlaufige Mitteilung] Zschr. ges. exp. Med, 1933, 89: 626-30.------Ein Verfahren zur Untersuchung der Pulsationen des Herzens und anderer Organe mittels Rontgenstrahlen. Klin. Wschr, 1936, 15: 310—Keys, A., Friedell, H. L. [et al] The Roentgen kymo- graphie evaluation of the size and function of the heart. Am. J. Roentg, 1940, 44: 805-33—Klioner, I. L, & Ivanov, N. I. [Roentgenokymographic study of the physiology of the heart] Ter. arkh, 1934, 12: 72-88. Also Fortschr. Rontgenstrahl, 1935, 51: 469-79.— Kottgen, H. U. Rontgenkymographische Untersuchungen des Herzens im Kindesalter. Erg. inn. Med. Kinderh, 1939, 56: 1-55.—Koga, Y. Ueber die phasenmassige Rontgenuntersuchung des Herzens; vorlaufige Mitteilung. Tohoku J. Exp. M, 1935, 27: 585-8, pl—Kudisch, B. M. [Functional-dynamic methods in cardio-roentgenologv] Vest. rentg, 1932, 11: 54-69. Also Fortsch. Rontgenstrahl, 1932, 46: 529-45—Kuhlmann, F, & Schiitt, H. Versuch einer rontgenkymographischen Herzfunktionsprufung. Klin. Wschr, 1939, 18: 609—Laurentius, P. Ueber Fehler in der Methodik und diagnostische Schwierigkeiten bei der Beurteilung der Herzstromkurve nach Belastung Zschr. Kreislaufforsch, 1941, 33: 170-6.—Lorens, J. [New rotating method in kymog- raphy of the heart] Polski przegl. radjol, 1935-36, 10:-11: 157-63, pl. Also J. radiol. dlectr, 1937, 21: 294-7—Ludwig, H. Negatives und Positives von der Herzkymographie. Fortsch. Rontgenstrahl, 1936, 54: 469-76. ------ Rontgenaufnah- men des Herzens wahrend bestimmter Aktionsphasen. Ibid, 1938, 57: 515-23.—Lutembacher, R. Cinematographic du coeur. Presse mdd, 1933, 41: 1919—Meldolesi, G, & Meldo- lesi, G. Contributo alio studio radiologico delle pulsazioni cardiache negli stati fisiologici e patologici del circolo. Radiol. med, Milano, 1926, 13: 597-629—Menzel, W. Ueber die diagnostische Verwertbarkeit der Rontgenkymographie. Klin. Wschr, 1934, 13: 245-9.—Meriel & Drouet. A propos de la kymographie en cardiologie. Bull. Soc. radiol. mdd. France, 1936, 24: 475.—Morelli, A. C, & Troullier, G. Roentgenkimo- grafia concdntrica. Rev. argent, card, 1935-36, 2: 434-45.— Panov, N. A. [Roentgenokymography of a normal child's heart] Pediatria, Moskva, 1938, No. 7-8, 32-5.—Parin, V. V., Glikin, M. I, & Ukolova, M. A. [New method of roentgen- physiological studv of cardiac activity] J. Physiol. USSR, 1936, 21: 956. Also Proc. Internat. Physiol. Congr. (1935) 1938, 15. Congr, 435—Perona, P. Sul metodo chimogratico italiano nella radiologia cardiaca. Cuore & circol, 1935, 19: 317-41—Ravina, A, & Cottenot, P. Opacification des cavites droites du coeur en systole et en diastole. Bull. Soc. med. hop. Paris, 1933, 3. ser, 49: 685- 7 Reindell, H. Kymo- graphische Beobachtungen uber die erhohte Restblutmenge beim Gesunden. Zschr. Kreislaufforsch, 1941, 33: 3S0.— Rivolta, L. F. Radiografias en sistole y en diastole. Rev. As. med. argent, 1934 48: 1287-9, 2 pl. ------■ Radiografia del corazon en sistole y diastole; dispositivo que permite su obtenci6n en relacion con los tonos cardiacos. Rev. argent. card, 1934-35, 1: 216-32.—Salotti, A. L'indagine radiologica nelle prove funzionali e nei riflessi tonici del cuore. Minerva med. Tor, 1928, 8: 1553-65.—Schnack, A. G. Roentgen kymography of the heart. Tr. Hawaii M. Ass, 1937, No. 47, D3 pl.—Serio. F. Studi di radiochimografia del torace; note di semeiologia radiocliimografica dell'apparato cardiovascolare. Riforma med, 1934, 50: 639.—Sousa, A. de. Sobre a ront- genquimografia cardiaca. Lisboa mdd, 1934, 11: 738-55.— Stumpf, P. Die Isographie und Kinematographie des Herzens. Fortsch. Rontgenstrahl, 1929, 40: 798-804. Also Munch. med. Wschr, 1929, 76: 1555-9. Also Brit. J. Radiol, 1934, 7: 707-27. ------ Die kymographische Analyse der Bewe- gungen des Herzens. Fortsch. Rontgenstrahl, 1934, 49: 211-24 [Erwiderung von Zdansky & Ellinger] 251. -----■ Bemerkungen zur Kritik der Kymographie des Herzens. Ibid, 1939, 59: 242-9.—Sundberg, C. G. The Roentgen kymogram of the normal heart. Acta radiol, Stockh, 1933, 14: 558-74, pl.—Teschendorf, W. Rontgenologische Herz- funktionsprufung. Fortsch. Rontgenstrahl, 1939, 60: 214-35. Also Zbl. Gyn, 1939, 63: 2083. Also Umschau, 1940, 44: 662-4.—Tice, G. M. Roentgen kymographie study of the heart. J. Kansas M. Soc, 1938, 39: 198-201.—Vallebona, A. La registrazione radiografica dei movimenti del cuore. Radiol. med, Milano, 1929, 16: 1004-16.—Von Der Weth, G. Ront- genkymographie des Herzens. Med. AVelt, 1936, 10: 1285-8 — Weber, H. Die Rontgenkymographie als neue klin sche Unter- suchungsmethode des gesunden und kranken Herzens. Schweiz. med. Wschr, 1934, 64: 819.—Westermark, N. Studien uber die Bewegungen des Herzens. Acta radiol, Stockh, 1936, 17: 235-51. ------ A study of the cardiac movements simultaneously recorded by roentgen-cinematography and electrocardiography. Ibid, 1941, 22: 393-403.—Wilke, A. Untersuchungen an Herzen mittels Rontgenkymographie. Fortsch. Rontgenstrahl, 1932, 46: 558-71.—Wolferth, C. C, & Margolies, A. Movements of roentgen-opaque deposits in heart valve areas; the excursion of the apex and base of the left ventricle compared with that of the left border. Am. J. M. Sc, 1939, 197: 197-201, pl—Wood, F.G. X-ray kymog- raphy of the heart. Lancet, Lond, 1939, 1: 249-52.— Zdansky, E, & Ellinger, E. Rontgenkymographische Unter- suchungen am Herzen. Mitt. Ges. inn. Med. Wien, 1933, 32: 99-103. Also Fortsch. Rontgenstrahl, 1933, 47: 648; 1934, 49: 240. Also Wien. med. Wschr, 1934, 84: 213; 928 — Zierach, H. J. Untersuchungen iiber die Konstanz der ront- OS HEART FUNCTION HEART FUNCTION genographisch darstellbaren Bewegungen des Herzens. Fortsch. Rontgenstrahl, 1934, 50: 16-29. ---- Test. Berland, A. S. Amplitudenfrequenzprodukt und funktio- nelle Diagnostik des Herzens. Zschr. Kreislaufforsch, 1933,25: 201-8.- Bondsdorff, B. von [Theoretical basis of functional heart tests] Kin. lak. sail, hand, 1935, 77: 463-85. Also Acta med. scand, 1936, Suppl. 78, 25-40 [Discussion] 8479 — Bruckner, G. Funktionspriifung des Herzens. Zschr. Kreis- laufforsch, 1936, 28: 721-7.—Burger, M. [DiskussionsvortagJ V<-rh. Deut. Ges. inn. Med, 1938, 50. Kongr, 103-9.—Cooper, G. W. The myocardium in physical examinations. Mil. Surgeon, 1927, 60: 42.5-37.—Doumer, E. The practical value of various heart tests. Med. Press & Circ, Lond, 1927, n. ser, 123: 379-81.--Ewig, W. Herzleistungsprufungen in der Praxis. Korbl. Allg. iirztl Verein. Thiiringen, 1932, 61: 18; 00. Graybiel, A, & White, P. D. Cardiac functional tests. Med. Clin. X. America, 1938, 22: 773-84.—Grossi. L. La valutazione dell'attitudine funzionale del cuore. Cas. ldk. cesk, 1937, 76: 707-18.—Gubergritz, M. M. [Functional diagnosis of the heart] Vrach. delo, 1928, 11: 1149-52.— Henderson, V. La valeur fonctionnelle du coeur et sa mesure. Bull, mdd. Par, 1926, 40: 1161-71.—Hochrein, M. Die Herzfunktionspriifung in der Praxis. Verh. Deut. Ges. inn. Med, 1938, 50. Kongr, 41-62.—Kupcinskas, J. [Functional examination of the heart] Medicina, Kaunas, 1939, 20: 252-64.—Ledent, R. Ce qu'il faut penser des dpreuves cardi- aques. Lidge mdd, 1937, 30: 1039-47.—Lepel, G. Herz- funktionsprufungen am gesunden und kranken Menschen. Erg. inn. Med. Kinderh, 1938, 54: 76-115.—Martini, P. Die Beurteilung der Gute des Herzens und die Diagnose der Herzschwache. Munch, med. Wschr, 1927, 74: 1998-2001 — Meixner, F. M. Cardiac functional diagnosis. Illinois M. J, 1934, 66: 559-63.—Monies Pareja, J. Exploraci6n funcional del miocardio. Arch. urug. med.. 1934. 4: 2-16.—Nippe. Die Beurteilung der Funktionstiichtigkcit des Herzens von Sektionsbefunden her. Aerztl Sachverst. Ztg, 1934, 40: 243-6.-—Paolillo, S. Nuove osservazioni in tema di prove funzionali del cuore. Athena, Roma, 1934, 3: 55-60.—Parade, G. W. [Diskussionsvortag] Verh. Deut. Ges. inn. Med, 1038, 50. Kongr, 129-36.—Pfeffer, F. Bedeutung der Funk- tioiisprufung und des Elektrokardiogramms fur die Beurteilung der Leistungsfahigkeit des Herzens. Med. Klin, Berl, 1938, 34: 1166.- Ratner, E. A. [Functional tests of the heart]. Klin. med. Moskva, 1928, 6: 1325 9— Schleicher, I. Die Heizfuiiktionsprufung. Umschau, 1939, 43: 534-6.—Siebeck, R. Die Beurteilung der Leistungsfahigkeit des Herzens. Deut. med. Wschr., 1939,65: 1561-5.—-Stanganelli, P. L'esame della funzionalita cardiaca; nota pratica. Athena, Roma, 1939, 8: 261-3.—Straub, H. Bericht uber die Funktionspriifung des Herzens. Verh. Deut. Ges. inn. Med, 1938, 50. Kongr, 30- 11. Also Zbl. inn. Med, 1938, 59: 387.—Valeur (De la) fonctionnelle du coeur. Vie mdd, 1929, 10: 1273.—Van Bogaert, A. Criteres d'apprdciation de la valeur fonctionnelle du coeur. Bruxelles mdd, 1934-35, 15: 651-7.—Walker, G. L. The measurement of the work of the heart and its clinical application. Bull. Fulton Co. M. Soc, 1934, 8: 3-7. Also ,1. M. Ass. Georgia, 1935, 24: 96-100.—Wiechmann, E. Die Beurteilung der Leistungsfahigkeit des Herzens. Med. Klin, Berl, 1939, 35: 1535.—Zak, E. Wie konnen wir die Funk- tionstiichtigkeit des Herzens beurteilen? Wien. klin. Wschr, 1929, 42: 1543. ---- Test: Blood pressure. See also Blood pressure. Niemann, F. Iv. *Herzfunktidnsprtifung mit der Biirgerschen Pressdruckprobe [Leipzig] 20p. 8? Zeulenroda, 1934. Avaritsiotis. De l'oscillomdtrie dans ses rapports avec la capacitd fonctionnelle du coeur. Gaz. hop, 1926, 99: 1192-5.— Barth, K. Die Prufung der Funktionstiichtigkeit des Herzens mit dem Blutdruckmesser. Miinch. med. Wschr, 1929, 76: 1049.—Gaffner, A. T, & Lascano, E. F. Indice oscilomdtrico y presion media; nueva aplicacion para clasificar grados de eficienciencia cardiaca. Prensa mdd. argent, 1933-34, 20: 1965-73.—Kabanow, N. Funktionspriifungen des Herzens und Blutdruck. Zschr. Kreislaufforsch, 1934, 26: 395-407.— Laniez, G. Sur une dpreuve fonctionnelle tensio-cardio- respiratoire. C. rend. Soc. biol, 1937, 125: 657-9.—Miura, G. Ueber den Wert des Kontraktionskoeffizienten und des Blut- druckquotienten bei der Funktionspriifung des Herzens. Acta Scholae med. Univ. Kioto, 1929, 12: 177-93.—Mortensen, M. A. Evaluation of cardiac efficiency by study of blood pressure. Current Res. Anesth, 1925, 4: 333-9. ---- Test: Diagnostic application. Thouvexel, A. *Remarques sur l'exploration fonctionnelle du coeur et des poumons chez les ecoliers. 40p. S° Par., 1929. Bottari, A. La valutazione della resistenza del cuore nella pratica clinica e medico-legale. Assist, sociale, Roma 1938 12: Suppl, No. 12, 3-24—Csinady, J, & Purjesz, B. [Im- portance of heart function test in sport medicine] Budapesti orv. ujs, 1932, 30: 9S5 8.—Filip, L. [Valuation of cardiac strength bv rontgenological tests for sport activities] Cas. ldk. cesk, 1926, 65: 113; passim. Libensky. ^ [Estimation of heart function in sports] Ibid, 1921, 63: 765. Moisseov, S. G, Bakhmutsky, N. B. [et al] [Functional diagnosis of the cardiovascular system in men employed in strenuous physical work] Ter. arkh.. 1932, 10: 187 503 — Ruf. S. Vergleichende Herzfimktionsprufungen in der Chirurgie. Beitr. klin. Chir 1928. 144: 488-504. Spohr, E, & Lampert, H. Kritisches zur Herzfunktionspriifung um besonderen bei Gutachten- fiillen) Munch, med. Wschr, 1930, 77: 491-5.-Viii, p, Contributo alio studio delle prove di funzionalita del cuore nei lavoro agricolo. Arch, antrop. crim. Tor, 1933, 53: 1713 21. ---- Test: Diuresis, and metabolism. See also Diuresis. Svman, S. *])<■!• Kauffmannsclie Wnsscr- versuch als Herzfunktionspriifung im Kindes- alter. p. 175-84. 8? Berl., 1935. Also Jahrb. Kinderh, 1935, 144. Arends, J. Die Prufung der Herzfunktion durch Wasser- versuche im Kindesalter. Zschr. Kinderh, 1932-33, 54: 620-30.—Avezzil, G. La stasi venosa provocata quale prova dello stato funzionale miocardico. Riv. clin. med, 1926, 27- 699-718.— Bauke, E. E. Der Wert des Kauffmarinsclici, Wasserversuches als Herzfunktionsprufungsmethode. Med Klin, Berl, 1934, 30: 163.—Brucke. K. Nachpriifungen des Kauffmannschen Versuches (Modifikation nach Heilbronner) Munch, med. Wschr, 1926, 73: 484.—Famulari, S. Lo studio delle forze di riserva del cuore con il carico idrico frazionato. Cult. med. mod. Pal, 1926, 5: 601-3.—Feyertag, G, & Caplun, E. Zur Verwertungsfrage des Kauffmannschen Diureseversuchs in Schwangerschaft und Puerperium. Mschr. Geburtsh. Gyn, 1930, 85: 223-32.—Frey, S. Die Bewertung des Kauffmannschen Diureseversuchs als Herzfunktionspru- fungsmethode. Beitr. klin. Chir, 1935,161: 254-63.—Frohlich, M. Funktionelle Herzdiagnostik unter besonderer Beruck- sichtigung der Kauffmannschen Probe. Prakt. Arzt, 1928, n. F, 13: 69-73.—Herlitzka, L, & Angeleri, A. Ricerche sulT importanza delle curve di carico con lattato di sodio come prova della funzionalita cardiaca. Arch, sc med. Tor, 1936, 62: 97-110.—Hoffmann, H. Beurteilung der Kauffmannschen Probe. Med. Klin, Berl, 1934, 30: 402.—Kummer, K. Sind der Bottnersche und der Kauffmannsche Versuch brauchbaie Methoden zur Herzfunktionspriifung bei Kindern? Mschr. Kinderh, 1939, 77: 203-14—Nagai, T. Wert des Kauff- mannschen Diureseversuchs zur Prognosestellung bei gyna- kologischer Operation. Nippon fujinkagakkai zasshi, 1935, 30: 1.—-Pein, H. von. Der Kauffmannsche Wasserversuch alB Herzfunktionsprufung. Klin. Wschr, 1933, 12: 1935.— Ruhbaum & Gemeinhardt. H. Der diagnostische Wert des Kauffmannschen Diureserversuchs. Deut. med. Wschr, 1935, 61: 1586-9.—Tiller, G. Ueber den Kauffmannschen Wasser- versuch im Kindesalter (D27) Arch. Kinderh, 1939, 117: 81-95.—Tschopp, W. Der Kauffmannsche Diureseversuch als Herzfunktionsprufung. Helvet. med. acta, 1937, 4: 488-92.— Vysotzky, N. N. [Kaufmann's method of diagnosis of cardiac insufficiency] Omsky med. J, 1927, 2: 3-7.—Zimmermann, O. Der Wert des Kauffmannschen Wasserversuches als Methode der Funktionsprufung des Herzens. Med. Klin, Berl, 1933, 29: 1437; 1934, 30: 267. ---- Test: Military aspect. Ask-Upmark, E. [Heart examination for military service] Tskr. mil. halsov, 1937, 62: 1-10.—Bourne, G. Examination of the heart in recruits. Brit. M. J, 1490, 2: 442-5.—Chamber- lain, E. N. The recruit's heart. Ibid, 1941, 1: 354-6 — Dumas, A., & Gravier, L. Coeur et aptitude militaire. J. mdd. Lyon, 1940, 21: 167-72.—Examination of the recruit's heart [Great Britain] J. Am. M. Ass, 1940, 115: 1212.— Lehmann, R. Das Herz und seine militararztliche Begutach- tung. Deut. med. Wschr, 1938, 64: 1190-3.—Lewis, J. S. The recruit's heart; preliminary report. Practitioner, Lond., 1940 145: 192-6.—Lowry, E. F. Evaluation of heart signs in Navy recruiting. Mil. Surgeon, 1942, 90: 37-44.— Nisse, B. S. The examination of the heart in men of military age. Med. Press & Circ, Lond, 1941, 206: 369-73.—Olmer. Pieri [et al] Electrocardiographie et aptitude militaire; rdsultats pratiques. Marseille mdd, 1940, 77: 118- Parkinson, J. Cardiac examination in wartime. Brit. M. J, 1940 1: 428- 30.—Recruit's (The) heart. Lancet, Lond, 1940, 2: 165. - Steinmann, B. Ueber die Beurteilung des Herzens im Mili- tardienst. Schweiz. med. Wschr, 1940, 70: 125-8— Wood, F. C, Wolferth, C. C, & Miller, T. G. Electrocardiography in military medicine, with special reference to its lack of value in the study of recruits. War Med, Chic, 1941, 1: 696-709. ---- Test, respiratory [Valsalva] Engelbrecht, A. *Unt(>rsuchungen iiber den dosicrten Valsalvaschen Versuch an gesunden Herzen [Konigsberg] 8p. 8? [Berl.] 1920. Also Fortsch. Med., 1926,14: 779-81. HEART FUNCTION Sirakoff, N. W. *Ueber Blutdruckverande- rungen bei dem Valsalva'schen Versuch und ihre Bedeutung als Herzfunktionsprufungsmethode. p.227-36. 8? Wiirzb., 1930. Also Deut. Arch. klin. Med, 1930, 166: Albert, A. H . & Klaus, E. J. Die morphologischen und funktionellen Herzveranderungen im dosierten Valsalvaschen Versuch bei jugendlichen Wettkampfsportlern; Untersuchungen im Stufenvalsalva. Deut. Arch. klin. Med, 1938-39, 183: 315-32. ------ Untersuchungen uber die Umgestaltung der Herzstromkurve unter der Einwirkung der intrapulmonalen Drucksteigerung (Stufenvalsalva) bei jugendlichen Wett- kampfsportlern. Ibid, 1939, 184: 546-61.—Amiral, H. H. Reaction of the diastolic pressure to the cardio-respiratory test. Abstr. Proc Ass. Life Insur. M. Dir. America, 1928, 14: o(9_49 —Antal, E. [Der Valsalva Versuch in der Rontgendiag- nostik des Herzens] Magy. rontg. kozl, 1938, 12: 89-95.— Bendixen, H. Zur Funktionspriifung des Herzens durch Dvspnoeversuche. Zschr. klin. Med, 1930-31, 115: 271-85.— Bethea, O. W. Some modifications of the cardiorespiratory test of Frost. South. M. J, 1928, 31: 783-5.—Burger, M, Biirger, H, & Petersen, P. F. Die Pressdruckprobe als Herzleistungsprufung. Arbeitsphysiologie, 1928-29, 1:614- 24.—Chernogorov, I. A, & Egorov, P. I. Zum Problem der Herzfunktionsprufung mittels des modifizierten Valsalva- Versuchs. Zschr. ges. exp. Med, 1929, 67: 206-18.—De Laet, M. Le quotient cardio-respiratoire normalisd; test de sdlection professionnelle et sportive pour l'adulte masculin. Arch. mdd. sociale, Brux, 1939, 2: 11-5.—Eremin, M. S. [Hyperventila- tion of the lungs as a functional method of heart examination] Vrach. delo, 1931, 14: 391-3.—Frost, H. M. The cardio- respiratorv test; analvsis of experience for the first five years. Abstr. Proc Ass. Life Insur. M. Dir. America, 1928, 14: 183-218, 14 ch.—Galli, G. L'escalier respiratoire apres l'dpreuve de Valsalva. Arch, internat. physiol, Lidge, 1923-24, 22: 187-92.—Gonczy, I. Weitere Untersuchungen iiber die Atmung als Indikator der Leistungsfahigkeit des Herzens. Zschr. ges. exp. Med, 1926, 52: 542-7.—Harrison, T. R, Harris, S, jr, & Calhoun, J. A. The clinical value of the ven- tilation test in the estimation of cardiac function. Am. Heart J, 1931, 7: 157-64.—Harrison, T. R., Turley, F. C. [et al] Congestive heart failure; the measurement of ventilation as a test of cardiac function. Arch. Int. M, 1931, 48: 377^-98.— Klaus, E. J. Ueber die Abhangigkeit des Valsalva-Effektes von der Korperkonstitution nach Untersuchungen im dosierten Pressdruck an jugendlichen Wettkampfsportlern. Zschr. menschl. Vererb, 1938-39, 22: 356-72. ------ & Albert, A. H. Die morphologischen und funktionellen Herzverande- rungen im dosierten Valsalvaschen Versuch bei jugendlichen Wettkampfsportlern; Untersuchung bei mittlerem Pressdruck. Deut. Arch. klin. Med, 1938, 182: 477-505.—Korobov, D. M, [Changes in Valsalva's test, under the effect of atropinization. in relation to the clinical importance of the test] Klin, med, Moskva, 1929, 7: 286-92.—Natvig, P. The volume of the heart in Midler's and Valsalva's tests. Acta radiol, Stockh, 1934, 15: 657, pl.—Nolte, F. A. Ueber die Veranderung der Herzform und -grosse unter der Einwirkung intrapulmonaler Drucksteigerung nach kardiokymographischen Untersu- chungen (das Kardiokymogramm im Valsalvaschen Versuch) Fortsch. Roentgenstrahl, 1934, 50: 211-30.—Palcso, B. [Value of Valsalva test in functional diagnosis of the heart] Orv. hetil, 1927, 71: 1201-3. Also Zschr. Kreislaufforsch, 1928, 20: 457-63.—Pressman, A. P. [Dicrotic pulse wave on common sphvgmogram in Valsalva test] Klin, med, Moskva, 1931, 9: 523-6. Also Zschr. Kreislaufforsch, 1932, 24: 40-6 — Sakin, M. M, Kharan, V. A, & Jagolkovsky, A. A. [Examina- tion of the functional properties of the cardiac activity with application of Valsalva's method] Klin, med, Moskva, 1933, 2: 1108-17— Theodoresco, B, & Asian, A. L'dpreuve de Valsalva dtudide par la mdthode tensioplethysmographique chez le sujet normal. Bull. Acad. mdd. Roumanie, 1939, 4: 103-12.—Wezler, K, & Knebel, R. Die Analyse der zentralen und peripheren arteriellen Pulse des Menschen im Valsalvaschen Pressversuch. Zschr. Biol, 1937, 98: 302-24. --- Test: Strength, and endurance. Fellbaum, H. *Veranderung der Dauer des QRS-Komplexes nach Belastung als Herzfunk- tionsprufung. 15p. 21cm. Giessen, 1938. Heller, T. *Puls, Atemfrequenz und Atem- tiefe nach dosierter Arbeit zur Prufung der Leistungsfahigkeit des Herzens. 13p. 8? Stet- ten, 1936. Reixdell, H. *Untersuchungen iiber die Belastungs-Arrhythmie. 32p. 8? Bonn, 1935. Steinberger, J. *Ueber den Einfluss korper- licher Bewegungen auf die Pulsfrequenz bei Gesunden und Kranken; ein Beitrag zur funk- tionellen Herzprufung. 28p. 8? Erlangen, 1910. Barath, E. Zur Frage der Funktionsprufung des Herzens durch Blutdruckkurven nach Arbeitsbelastung. Munch. med. Wschr, 1930, 77: 1235.—Dawson, P. M, & Hodges, P. C. HEART FUNCTION Lifting and the Valsalva experiment; effect on systolic pressure heart rate and radial pulse curve in man, with a note on labor' pains in a rabbit, Am. J. Physiol, 1916, 40: 139— Dungern M. von. Die Dauer des Kammer-Elektrogramms QT im Ekg gesunder Schulkinder vor und nach Herzbelastung Zschr Kreislaufforsch, 1939, 31: 739-42— Felberbaum, D, & Finesilver, B. A simplified test of cardiac tolerance. Med J. & Rec, 1927, 126: 36-9.—Greene, J. A, & Swanson. L. w! Clinical studies of respiration: VI. Expiratory inflation during air hunger and dyspnea produced by physical exertion in normal subjects and in patients with heart disease. Arch. Int. M. 1938, 61: 720-5—Heninger, B. R. The exercise tolerance test (Master and Oppenheimer) in the estimation of the capacity of the diseased heart. South M. J, 1039, 32: 262-7. Also repr. Also Brit. Homoeop. J, 1939, 29: 330.—Herziim, A. Meine Erfahrungen mit einer neuen Pulsbelastungsprobe Deut. med. Wschr, 1938, 64: 448.—Kaliaeva, S. I. [Signifi- cance of certain, so-called functional tests for the evaluation of the working capacitv of the circulatory apparatus] Ter arkh, 1939, 17: No. 4, 76-85.—Katz, L. ISL, Soskin, S. [et al] A metabolic exercise tolerance test for patients with cardiac disease; a feasible method for using the excess oxygen con- sumption and the recovery time of exercise as criteria of the cardiac status. Arch. Int. M, 1934, 53: 710-23.—Lauber, H. Herzleistungsprufung am Menschen mit Hilfe von Herz- arbeitskurven. Verh. Deut. Ges. inn. Med, 1930, 42. Kongr, 253-6.—Master, A. M. The two-step test of myocardial function. Am. Heart J, 1934-35, 10: 495-510.—Pein, H. von. Die Messung des Gasstoffwechsels bei Belastungen als Herz- funktionspriifung. Zschr. klin. Med, 1937, 123: 227-45.— Reisinger, J. A. The determination of exercise tolerance by the two-step test. Am. Heart J, 1938, 15: 341 53.—Schlomka, G. Das Belastungs-Elektrokardiogramm; Untersuchungen iiber Korrelationen im Belastungselektrokardiogramm. Ar- beitsphysiologie, 1934-35, 8: 705-41.—Schone, G. Das Belastungselektrokardiogramm als Herzfunktionsprobe. Verb Deut. Ges. inn. Med, 1938, 50. Kongr, 121-4.—Tuttle, W. W. The use of the pulse-ratio test for rating physical efficiency. Res. Q. Am. Phys. Educ. Ass, 1931, 2: 5-17. Wolffe, .1. B. Cardiac capacity determined by standardized effort. A i ch Int. M, 1926, 38: 761-9.—Wright, G. W., Hallaran, W. R.. & Wiggers, C. J. The economy of effort index for hearts of normal and hypertensive subjects. Am. J. PhvsioL, 1930, 126: 89-96. ---- Test: Various methods. Doerfler, J. *Zur Frage der klinischen Brauchbarkeitder Chlorcalciuminjektion als Herz- funktionspriifung. 44p. 22cm. Erlangen, 1930. Kessler, H. *Vergleichende Untersuchungen iiber einzelne Herzfunktionsproben unter be- sonderer Berucksichtigung ihrer Eignung fiir gutachterliche Entscheidungen [Jena] 46p. 8? Borna-Lpz., 1934. Munch, E. *Zur Methodik der Herzfunk- tionsprufung. 22p. 8? Munch., 1931. Schmidt, H. W. *Beitrag zur Frage der Herzfunktionsprufungen [Wurzburg] 47p. 8? Ochsenfurt, 1937. Atzler, E. Neues Verfahren zur Funktionsbeurteilung des Herzens. Deut. med. Wschr, 1933, 59: 1347-9.—Avezzu, G. La stasi venosa provocata quale prova dello stato funzionale miocardico. Riv. clin. med, 1926, 27: 699-718.—Barry, D. T., & O'Dohovan, W. J. The form of the venogram and cardiac efficiency. Arch, internat. mdd. exp, Lidge, 1925-26, 2: 311-23.—Benedetti, P. Metodo per la valutazione indi- viduate del cuore. Endoer. pat. cost, Bologna, 1935, 10: 237-85, 3 ch.—Blumenthal, B. Practical application of the metabolic exercise tolerance test to the treatment of heart disease. Am. Heart J, 1936, 12: 736-9.—Borgard, W, & Hermannsen, J. Kombinierte Herz- und Lungenfunktions- prufung. Deut. Arch. klin. Med, 1933, 175: 545-56.— Bossin, A. [Correlation between cardiac functional deficiency and.quantity of bilirubin in blood-serum] Vrach. gaz., 1928 32: 504-7.—Brauer. Examen funcional combinado de cora- zon y pulmones. Dfa mdd, B. Air, 1934-35, 7: 371-6, portr — Brauer, L. Gasanalytische Herzfunktionsprufung. Verh. Deut. Ges. inn. Med, 1938, 50. Kongr, 78-84.—Capriglione, L, & Benchimol, A. B. A determinacao da velocidade da corrente sangufnea pelo gluconato de calcio e o seu valor como teste funcional cardiaco. Hospital, Rio, 1939, 16: 7-22.— Christensen, E, Krogh, A, & Lindhard, J. [Examination of the muscular functions of the heart] Bibl. laeger, 1935, 127: 1-38.—Danielopolu, D, Simici, D. [et al] Action directe de l'atropine sur le myocarde, son importance dans l'dpreuve de ['atropine et de l'orthostatisme. Bull. Soc. mdd. hop. Bucarest, 1926, 8: 197-209.—D'Ignazio, C, & Guarino, A. Sopra una nuova prova funzionale del cuore. Cuore & circol, 1932, 16: 65-79.—Enthoven, P. H. [Functional examination of the heart] Ned. tschr. geneesk, 1927, 71: pt 2, 2328-36.—Flaunt, E. Freilich nicht an zahlreichen Versuchen gefehlt, brauchbare Herzfunktionsprufungen. Wien. med. Wschr, 1935, 85: 185-7.—Fiirst. Die Beurteilung der Leistungsfahigkeit des HEART FUNCTION 310 HEART FUNCTION Herzens. Hippokrates, Stuttg, 1941, 12: 207-10. Giinczy. I. [Liagnosis of heart functions] Orv. hetil, 1926, JO: 1247 50.— Grortberg, A, & l.undberg, A. Quantitative systematische I robilinbcstiiiimungen als Herzfunktionsprobc vor Operationen (einige Erfahrungen bei Morbus Basedowii) Acta med. scand, 1930, <4: 129-47.— II n burger, F. Leber praktische Prufung der !h rzleistungsfaliifkeit beim Kind. Med. Klin, Berl, 1038. 34: 391- Harrison, T. R. Functional tests of the heart. Mod. Concepts Card. Dis, 1934, 3: 1.—Janousek. S, .— beet hi rr. C. L. A simple, accurate test of myocardial function. Flight Surgeon Topics, 1939, 3: 23-5, tab.—Leite, N. Valor sen iotico da prova da fluorescencia na avaliacao da capacidade funccional do coracao. Brasil med., 1931. 45: 289-93.—Levitan, H. N, & Friedman, H. N. [On functional f-t of the heart] Russ. klin, 1928, 10: 314-22.— MscKenzie, I . F„ Wells. P. V. fetal.] Flarimeter tests. Abstr. Proc A-.-. Life Insur. M. Dir. America, 1931, 17: 8-44.— Mattioli, M. Le prove di funzionalita cardiaca. Gior. med. prat, 1938. 20: 196-204.—Meczner, L. Neue Herzfunktions- prufung nit Verneiden des Einflusses der habitualen Puls- h' quenz. Wien. Arch. inn. Med, 1934, 25: 463 8.—Messinger. K. The estimation of cardiac function by simple clinical methods. Ann. Int. M, 1936-37, 10: 980-99.—Minerbi, C. Intorno al mio processo cardio-tono-cimentatoie trisposla nl dott. Rolandi-Ricci) Cuore & circol, 1929, 13: 221 8 — Moore. J. W, Haniltcn, W. F, & Kinsman, J. M. Ethyl iodide method for determining the circulation; as a functional test of the heart. J. Am. M. Ass, 1926, 87: 817-21. Also repr.-—Nylin, G. Attempt at functional cardiac diagnosis. Acta med. scand, 1932, 79: Suppl. 50, 54-6. ------ [Method in functional diagnosis of the heart] Sven. liik. tidn, 1932, 29: 315-20. Also Zschr. klin. Med, 1931, 118: 584-95. ------ Clinical tests of the function of the heart. Acta med. scand, 1033, SO: Suppl. 52, 1-92. ------ Functional heart tests and their clinical significance. Ibid, 1936, Suppl. 78, 64-84 [Discussion] S4-9. ------ More recent developments of heart function tests. J. Am. M. Ass, 1937, 109: 1333-7. ----- Die klinisch brauchbaren Herzfunktionsprufungen und ihre klinische Bedeutung. Zbl. inn. Med, 1937, 58: 529-47 — Perili, E. La provocazione della stasi venosa degli arti come metodo d'indagine della funzionalita del cuore. Riv. clin. med, 1926, 27: 859-71. ------ II tono del cuore e la fun- zionalite miocardica studiata col metodo della stasi venosa provocata. Cuore & circol, 1927, 11: 290-7.—Pfeifer. W. Herzfunktionsprufung im Rontgenbild. Fortsch. Rdntscn- strahl, 1038, 58: 547-56.—Posteli, T, & Tolomelli, E. Prova funzionali' cardiaca con el"< trocardiogiammi registradi ad alta velociti. Bull. sc. med, Bologna, 1939, 111: 2-17-61.— Probst. Funktionsprufung des Kreislaufes gesunder Schwan- gerer. Arch. Gyn, Berl, 1938, 166: 59-62 [Discussion] 81-8.— Pruche, A. Les mesure« en clinique circulatoire, leur technique, leur interpretation; comment determiner la valeur fonctionnelle du caur. Clinique, Par, 1929, 24: 241-3. -----■ Comment determiner la valeur fonctionnelle du coeur; les epreuves myocardiques dynamiques. Arch. mal. coeur, 1935, 28: 485-507.—Re-zeeh, J. [Examination of cardiac efficiency] Gy6gyaszat, 1937. 77: 130.—Samter, J. F. |Krampton's Index as functional test of the heart] J. eksp. biol, 1929. 11: 82-5.—Scherf. D. Die Amylnitntprobe als Funktionspriifungsmethode des spezifischen Herzniuskelsv- srems. Wien. klin. Wschr, 1927, 40: 113-6.—Schultz, W. Herzleistungsprufungen bei Reihenuntersuchungen von Kin- dern. Munch, med. Wschr, 1937, 84: 772-5.--Siebeck, R. Leber HerzfunktioiisprUtuiigen. Jahrkurs. aiztl. loitbild, 1934, 25: H. 2, 56-60.,-Slot. G. A clinical method of ctitnai- ing cardiac efficiency in children, and the work of a Rheuma- tism Supervisory Cennc. Pioc R. Soc M, Lond, 1928-29, 22: Sect. Stud. Di-. Child, 59-64.—Smagin, G. A, & Toma- shevsky, R. I. I Estimating functional capacity of heart] Klin. med. M.-kva, 1929,7: 201-10.—Solerary Dopff. C. La medida di. L capacidad funcional del corazon mediante la absorci6n de gases extrafio- el ioduro zfm ktionspriifung im Kindesalter. Veil. Dem Gis. inn. MkL. 1938. CO. Kongr, 63-73— Titov, B. P, tv LeGre, A. A. 'Ik 'h\ sinography as a method of determination of functional ability of the heart] Med. biol. J, Leningr, 1927, 3: 38-49.—Van Bogaert, A. Criteres d'appreciation de la valeur foi,( tionnelle du caur. Bruxelles m6d, 1934-35, 15: 601: 623.--Vnvfi, M. S. [Photographic registration of the venous pulse by Ohm as a method of cardiac test] Med. biol. J, Leningr, 19-'S 1:3-14.—Weber, A. Physikalische Metho- den der Herzfunktionsprufung. In Handb. biol. Arbeitsmeth. (Abderhalden, E.) 1935. Abt. V. T. 8, 989-10C5. ---- Variation. Bishop. L F, jr. Your age and your heart. Hygeia, Chic, 19.JS. 16: 116-9.—Brandberg. O. [Electrocardiogram and [monocardiogram in childhood] \ord. med, 1910. 8: 2117.— Gelman, I, A. Brown. S. On the functional evolution of the cardio-va-.-okn system in man; <>n the problem of the age changes ..i i lie functional .■xcitabihtv of the heart with respect to seveial \< ".etative irritants. Acta med. scand, 1937. !H : 541-9.—Helfand. A, & t hernov. A. [Functional changes of the heart due to various stimulants] Klin, med, Moskva, 103S. 16: 328-3S. —Honly, G. Observations on the blood pressure and cardiac rhythm during sunned conditions. Bir- mingham M. Rev, 1927, n. ser.. 2: 195 216. Merklen, L. Influence de la temperature sur 1 eflet caidiaque de I excitation de la moelle lombaire. C. rend. Soc. biol, 1920, 95: 106.— Roncato, A. La funzione cardiaca durante 1 insuflaziono alia Meltzncr.Auer. Boll. Soc. biol. sper, 1926, 1 : 284-6.—Schlom- ka, G. Leber Alternsanderungen der Herzfunktion. Zschr Altersforsch, 1938-39. 1: 38-18.—Stcinert, R. Leber die Beeinflussung von Lage und Funktion des Herzens durch Thoraxbau und Zwciehfellstund. Deut. Arch. klin. Med, 1926-27, 154: 257-86.—W illius, F. A. The heart throughout the various periods of life. J. Iowa M. Soc, 1937, 27: 187 -91. ---- Variation: Altitude, climate, and tempera- ture. Markowsky, S. *Ueber die Beeinflussung der Herztatigkeit durch die Temperatur. p.231- 48. 8? Jena, 1933. Also Biol, gen, Wien, 1933, 9: Belehradek, J. Ralentissement progressif de l'activite cardiaque k des temperatures basses. Arch, internat. physiol, Liege, 1928-29, 30: 205-10.—Benson, S. Relative influence of external and body temperatures upon the heart. Arch. Phys. Ther, 1934, 15: 303.— Boger, A, Cobct, R, s*v Also repr.—Rosnowski. M. Influcuee de I'efTort eorporel sur le coeur che?- les sportifs. Arch. mal. eoeur, 1937. 30: 133-40.—Schenk. P. Das Herz des Sport- mann.w. Arzt & Sport, 1935, 1: 33 5.—Schlomka. G.. & Reindell, H. Das Belastungs-Llektrokardiogramm; Unter- suchungen an Sportlern. Arbeitsph vsiologie, 1934-35. 8: 172-217.- Schmidt. F. A. Herz und'Sport. Zschr. Schul- gesundh, 1025, 38: 70.—Simonson, E. Einige Probleme des Kreislaufs- bei korperlicher Arbeit. Klin. Wschr, 1935. 14: 267-70.- Spvchala, W. [Sports and the circulatory apparatus] Nowiny lek., 1037. 49: 600-0.—Stewart H. E. The effect of exercise upon the heart. Phys. Ther, 1927. 45: 202.—Stine, D. G. Effect of work upon the heart. J. Missouri M. Ass, 1938, 35: 443-7.—Theodoresco, B. Coeur et exercices phy- siques. Bull, mid.. Par, 1936, 50: 879-82.—Thorner, W. Sport und Herz. Med. Welt, 1927, 1: 683-6.—Tinker, M. S, & Bernstein, I. Z. [Changes in cardio-vascular system, blood ;md urine in athletic competitions] Vrach. delo, 1926, 9: 1057-64.—Tomaszewski, W. [Changes in the electrocardio- gram after physical effort] Polska gaz. lek, 1936, 15: 677-81.— Trabucchi, C. Le modificazioni dell' elettrocardiogramma dopo lo sforzo. Atti Soc. med. chir. Padova, 1933, ser. 2, 11: 910- 6—Tung, C. L, Hsieh, C. K. [et al] The hearts of riksha pullers; a studv of the effect of chronic exertion on the cardio- vascular system. Am. Heart J, 1934, 9: 79-100.—Tuttle, W. W. Re.-ponse of the heart to exercise of graded intensitj. Proc Soc Lxp. Biol, N. Y, 1930-31, 28: 598. ------ & Korns, H. M. Electrocardiographic observations on athletes before and after a season of physical training. Am. Heart J, 1941, 21: 104-7.—Tuttle, W. W, & Walker. F. H. The effect of a season of training and competition on the response of the hearts of high school boys. Res. Q. Am. Ass. Health, 1940, 11: No. 4, 78-81.—Vakar, A. A. [Muskular strength and heart function] Ter. arkh, 1937, 15: 110-17.—Vetokhin, I. A. I Hole of maximum muscular tension in spontaneous changes of heart action] In Recueil Strajesko (Bogomoletz, A.) Kiev, 1035, 735-46.—Viziano, A, & Velicogna, A. Ricerche elettro- cardiografiche nella fatica sportiva. Rass. med. lavoro indust, 1933, 4: 43-54—Warfield, L. M. The heart and athletics. Mod. Concepts Card. Dis, 1934, 3: No. 5, L—White, P. D. The effect of strain on the heart. Tr. Congr. Am. Physicians, 192S. 14: 62- 75. Also N. England J. M, 1928, 199: 801-7 — Wilrc, J. W. Athletic, heart; modern conceptions and a recent investigation. J. Lancet, 1936, 56: 557-64.—Wilmaers, A. Examen des conditions circulatoires de certains concurrents au Gross. Bruxelles med, 1937-38, 18: 381-3.—Zaeper. G. Leber die Kreislaufleistung bei Muskelarbeit. Zbl. inn. Med, 1937, 58: 305-18. ---- Variation: Mental factors. Steger, J. Herz und Seele (Untersuchungen iiber die Herz- tatigkeit unter bestimmten geistigen und kbrperlieheii Be- dingungen bei gesunden und kranken Menschen) Arch. ges. Psvchol, 1936, 96: 33-60.—Tomaszewski. W. [Psyche and heart] Nowiny lek, 1937. 49: 425-30.—Wyss, W. H. von. Herz und Psyche in ihreu Wechselwirkungon. Sclnveiz. med. Wschr, 1927;57:433-6. ---- Variation: Pathological factors. See also Heart disease, functional; also under names of diseases. Kimmio, H. *Untersuchungen iiber die Wirkung des Kopfdrucks bei Neugeborenen auf die Herztatigkeit [Munchen] lip. 8? Schwetzin- en [1935] Bachmann, H. Leistungsfahigkeit und Automatie des Kaltbluterherzens in Anoxybiose, nebst Beitrag zur Wirkungs- starke natiirlicher Erregungen. Arch. ges. Physiol, 1927, 217: 151-83.—Beck, C. S, & Isaac, L. Pneumocardiac tamponade; a study of the effects of atmospheric pressure, negative pressure and positive pressure upon the heart. J. Thorac. Surg, 1931, 1: 124-48.—Blalock, A. Exposure of the heart to atmospheric pressure; effects on the cardiac output and blood pressure. Arch. Surg, 1933, 26: 516-21.—De Waele, H. Le mecanisme acc£16rateur et mod^rateur du coeur en acidose et en alcalose. Arch, internat. physiol, Liege, 1926, 26: 428-44. ------ Ije mecanisme accel£rateur et moderateur du cceur en acidose et en alcalose. Bull. Acad. med. Belgique, 1926,5. ser, 6: 244- 63, 2 ch. —---- Influence de l'alcalose et de l'acidose sur le mecanisme mod6rateur et acc616rateur du cceur et sur Taction des substances vago- et svmpathieomim6tiques. C. rend. Soc biol, 1926, 94: 1041.—Felix, W. Tatigkeit des Herzens bei verschieden starkem Druck auf seine Oberflache. Deut. Z.-ehr. Chir, 1930, 229: 1-42.—Hamilton, R. L. The child's heart in health and disease. Arch. Pediat, N. Y, 1930 47: 405-13.—Liljestrand, G, & Stenstrom, N. The work of the heart at different haemoglobin content of the blood and in cases with high arterial blood pressure. Acta med. scand, 1026, Suppl. 16: 438.—Nolte. F. A. Ueber die Veranderung der Herzform und Grosse unter ein Einwirkung intrapul- monaler Drucksteigerung. Wien. med. Wschr, 1936, 86: 917.—Rijlant, P. Les variations de l'activite cardiaque spon- tanees et reactionnelles au cours de l'anaphylaxie locale; auto- matismes secondaires. Arch, internat. physiol, Liege, 1924, 23: 61-02. ------ Action du s6rum homologuc traite par I'agar sur l'activite apontanee et rcactionnelle du coeur isole el des oreillettes droite et gauche isolees du lapin; choc iiiia- ph.ylaetoMe et automatisme* .secondaires. Ibid, 375-93. Scheinfinkel. N. Lntersuchungen iiber die Abhangigkeit dor \rbeitsleistung des Froschherzens von den mechanisclien laktoren mit besonderer Beriicksichtigung der Kompensa- tionsmoglichkeiten bei Anoxybiose bezieliungsweise hocli- Kradigeiii Sauerstoffmangel. Zschr. Biol, 1032 33, 93: 266 82. Varek, T. Lntersuchungen iiber die fuiiktionelle Adapta- tion des Herzens bei den im SaueistolTmaiigel lebendcn Miiisen Arch. ges. Physiol, 1926, 212: 357-64. ---- Variation: Physical agents. See also under names of physical agents as Bath, Effect—on blood and circulation, &c. Ajisaka, S. An experimental study on the effect of x-rav to the heart. Jap. J. Obst. Gyn., 1036, 19: 430-56, 3 pl— Arkussky, U. I., & Mintz, M. M. [Effect on the heart of Roentgen and radium irradiation of the cervical region] Vest. rentg, 1938, 20: Anniv. No. 38-50. ------& Chochia, K. N. [Effect of roentgentherapy and radiotherapy on the heart] Ibid, 1937, 18: 334-42.—Dusek, M. Les radiations et l'acti- vite du coeur. C. rend. Soc. biol, 1939, 130: 382-4- Ever- dingen, W. A. G. van [Short-wave irradiation of the heart Ned. tschr. geneesk, 1937, 81: 106-11.—Firson, A. J, & Pruss, G. M. [Effect of d'Arsonval's current on the isolated heart of the frog] Fizioterapia, Moskva, 1939, No. 6, 85 90. - Galata, G. Ricerche sulle reazioni atriali e ventricolari alio variazioni di pressione interna ed esterna, nei cuore isolato di bufo. Arch, fisiol., Fir, 1927, 25: 766-91.—Gleser, D. J. [Effect of ultra-short waves on the heart of the frog] J. Physiol USSR, 1936, 20: 828-45.—Guttman, S. A. Effect of ultra- violet radiation on the heart of Limulus polyphemus. Biol. Bull, 1936, 70: 279-81.—Heinle, R. W., & Phelps, K. R. The effect of short radio waves on perfused cats' hearts. Am. J. Physiol, 1933, 104: 349-51.— Herbst, R. Herzgrosse und Luftdruckverminderung. Verh. Deut. Ges. Kreislaufforsch, 1936, 9: 290-5.—Hinrichs, M. A. Ultraviolet point radiation focussed through a quartz rod and effect on fundulus heart beat. Proc Soc. Exp. Biol, N. Y, 1929-30, 27: 354-7 — Kurbatova, I. N. [On the significance of the frequency factor for the biological effect of the electric field of high frequency; frequency dependence of the adrenergic effect of ultra-high frequency on the heart of the frog] Biull. eksp. biol. med, 1939, 8: 429-31.—Laubry, C, Tournier, J. [et al] Action des ondes courtes sur le cosur isol6. Presse m6d, 1934, 42: 1280.— Martini, E. Azione delle onde elettromagnetiche ad alta frequenza sul cuore. Radiobiologia, Venez, 1932-34, 1: No. 4, 33-46.—Oana, M. Experimental study on heart function; influence of exposure to ultra-violet ray, roentgen ray and radium radiation on the function of extirpated toad heart. Jap. J. Exp. M, 1932, 10: 73-96.—Osawa, K. Ueber die photodynamische Wirkung der sichtbaren und ultravio- letten Strahlen auf das Froschherz. Jap. J. M. Sc, 1933-34, 3: Biophys, 55-68.—Palombra, G. Contributo alio Btudio elettrocardiografico sul cuore irradiate. Minerva med. Tor, 1938, 29: pt 2, 418-25.—Polak, E. Ueber den Einfluss radio- aktiver Strahlungen auf die automatische Tatigkeit des Froschherzens mit besonderer Rucksicht auf die Wirkung grosser Strahlendosen und auf den Antagonismus der a- und 0-Strahlung. Arch. ges. Physiol, 1930-31, 226: 659-75 — RofTo, A. E, & Taquini, A. Modificaciones electrocardiogrificas producidas por la aplicaci6n de ondas cortas. Rev. med. Rosario, 1935, 9: 1-15.—Toyoma, T. Ueber die Wirkung der Rontgenstrahlen auf das isolierte Froschherz. Tohoku J. Exp. M, 1932-33, 20: 591-5.—Zhdanov, I. M. [Changes in the nervous system of the heart and reactions of the barrier apparatuses during irradiation of the heart by roentgen rays] In Rec. trav. M. F. Melnikov-Razvedenkov, Kiev, 1939, 415-24.—Zwaardemaker, H. Die Technik radiophysiologischer Herzversuche. In Handb. biol. Arbeitsmeth. (Abderhalden, E.) Berl, 1927, Abt. 5, Teil 4, 1715-62. ------ Strahlung und Automatine im Doppelherzversuch. Strahlentherapie, 1927, 27: 413-25. ------ & Feenstra, T. P. Rontgenstrahlen und Herzautomatie. Ibid, 1928, 29: 527-33. ---- Variation: Pregnancy. See also Heart disease—in the pregnant; Heart failure—in the pregnant. Andreae, P. W. *Ueber die Wirkungen dor Schwangerschaft auf das gesunde und kranke Herz. 31p. 8? Bonn, P. Kubens, 1927. Bessim, I. A. *Ueber die kurzfristigen Spon- tanschwankungen des systolischen Blutdrucks bei Schwangeren, Kreissenden und Wochnerin- nen. 19p. 8? Freib. i. B., 1925. HtiLs, K. *Ueber das Verhalten des Herz- minuten-Volumens in der Schwangerschaft. 30p. 8? Bonn, 1932. Koff-Polikowsky, I. *L'influence de la gros- sesse normale sur le coeur. 28p. 8? Gtneve, 1908. HEART FUNCTION 313 HEART HORMONE Schroeder, C. *Ueber die Herzarbeit in der Schwangerschaft [Wurzburg] 53p. 8? Berl., 1932. Also Arch. Gyn, Berl, 1932, 150: Burckhardt, L. The heart of a pregnant woman. Tr. Am. Ass. Obst. Gyn. (1918) 1919, 31: 94-103.—Carreras, F, & Cortes, C. Modifications du cceur pendant la grossesse. Bull. Soc. obst. gvn. Paris, 1929, 18: 606-12. Also Rev. med. Barcelona, 1*929, 12: 416-25.—Clauser, F. Cuore e stato puerperale. Ann. ostet, gin. 1927, 49: 173-256.—Euflnger, H. Herzfunktion und Schwangerschaft. Mschr. Geburtsh. Gyn, 1928, 78: 395-401.—Gammeltoft, S. A. The heart in pregnancy. Surg. Gyn. Obst, 1028, 46: 382-90.—Heyne- mann. Herz und Zwerchfellstand wahrend der Schwanger- schaft. Verb. Deut. Ges. Gyn. (1913) 1914, 15: pt 2, 131.— Jensen, F. G, & Norgaard, A. Recherches cliniques, roent- g6nologiques et Electrocardiographiques sur des femmes saines au cours de la grossesse normale. C. rend. Soc. biol, 1926, 94: 1213-6.—Landt, H, & Benjamin, J. E. Cardiodynamic and electrocardiographic changes in normal pregnancy. Am. Heart J, 1936, 12: 592-607.—Merletti, C. Nuovi elementi per lo studio della funzionalitji cardiaca nello stato puerperale. Atti Soc. ital. ostet, 1906, 12: 270-5.—Musser, J. H, & Sodeman, W. A. Heart changes of unusual etiology in preg- nancy. Tr. Ass. Am. Physicians, 1939, 54: 181-7.—Nubiola, P., & Bellido, J. M. Electro-cardiographic observations dur- ing pregnancy. Tr. Internat. Congr. M. (1913) 1914, Sect. 8, Obst. Gyn, pt 2, 77.—Reid, W. D. The heart in pregnancy. J. Am. M. Ass, 1930, 95: 1468-72. Also repr.— Sachs, H. Ueber das Elektrokardiogramm der Schwangeren. Berl. klin. Wschr, 1920, 57: 803.—Schmidt [von Elmendorff] H. R. Arbeitsphysiologische Untersuchungen iiber die Herz- arbeit in der Schwangerschaft. Arch. Gyn, Berl, 1930-31, 144: 389-91 [Discussion] 399-413. ------ Das Ruhe- Herzminutenvolumen in der Spatschwangerschaft. Ibid, 1938, 166: 56-9 [Discussion] 81-8. Also Zbl. Gyn, 1938, 62: 72. ------ Effkemann, G., & Borgard, W. Das Ruhe- Herzminutenvolumen der Schwangeren. Arch. Gyn, Berl, 1938, 167: 230-9.—Slemons, J. M., & Goldsborough, F. C. Die geburtshilfliche Bedeutung des Blutdrucks und sein Verhaltnis zur Arbeit des Herzens. Zbl. Gyn, 1908, 32: 699-705.—Sussman, A. A. The heart and pregnancy. South. M. & S, 1926, 88: 722.—Zhevakhov, S. V. [Alterations in the heart in pregnancy] J. akush, 1912, 27: 551; 777; 1063, 2 pl.—Zocchi, S. Ricerche sulla capacity funzionale del cuore nello stato puerperale. Fol. gyn, Genova, 1933, 30: 1-53. HEART hormone. See also Heartbeat (Automatism; Regulation) Heart nerves; Muscle extract. Kalpen, E. *Klinische Untersuchungen iiber die sogenannten Herzhormone [Berlin] 22p. 8? Kallmiinz, 1932. Wenkebach, G. *Stand der Lehre von den Herzhormonen und anderen herztatigkeitsregu- lierenden Stoffen. 34p. 8? Berl., 1931. Bain, W. A. Les substances actives du cceur de mammimre. C. rend. Soc. biol, 1932, 109: 953.—Bauer, J. Ueber Herz- hormone. In Kreislauferkr. ihre Behandl, Lpz, 1932, 105- 15.—Brouha, L., & Bacq, Z. M. Recherches sur les substances actives du coeur des mammiferes. Arch, internat. physiol, Liege, 1936, 43: 492-509.—Brun, R. de. A propos des pre- tendues hormones cardiaques; notions nouvelles sur les extraits organiques. Rev. gin. chn. thir., 1934, 48: 337-40.—Carvalho, A. de. Recherche d'une hormone cardiaque chez la tortue. C. rend. Soc. biol, 1929, 102: 535-7.—Caso, G. Gli ormoni cardiaci. Morgagni, 1931, 73: 470-2.—Collazo, J. A, Puyal, J, & Torres, I. Hormonas cardiacas, acido lactico y glucosa de la sangre. Arch, med, Madr, 1933, 36: 599; 1934, 37: 437. Also Med. ibera, 1934, 28: 471.—Demoor, J. Contribu- tions k la physiologie g6n6rale du coeur; les proprietes des substances actives diff£renci6es par leur resistance k la chaleur. Arch. sc. biol. Nap, 1928, 12: 77-93. ------ Reglage humoral du coeur; hormones cardiaques. In R6gul. hormon. Par, 1937, 574-80. ■-----■ & Rijlant, P. Propri6tes des substances actives de l'oreillette droite du coeur. C. rend. Soc. biol, 1925, 93: 814-6. ------ Le reglage humoral du travail ventriculaire du cceur; les substances actives du tissu sous-endocardique. Ibid, 1926, 95: 219-21.—Extraits or- ganiques et spasme arteriel; un aspect nouveau de la question des hormones cardiaques. Presse mid., 1932, 40: 1762-5.— Galli, W. L'ormone cardiaco. Gazz. osp, 1933, 54: 97-9. Also Monit. endoer, 1934, 2: 42-6.—Gingold. N. [Cardiac hormones] Rev. st. med, Bucur, 1933, 22: 1053-75.—Gley, P. Ce qu'il faut penser de hormones cardiaques. Progr. med. Par, 1930, 673-8.—Hallion, L. Sur la presence de substances cardio-stimulantes dans le tissu du cceur. Rev. prat, biol. Par, 1929, 22: 97-105.—Katz, G., & Leibenson, E. A. Recherches sur les hormones cardiaques. C. rend. Soc. biol, 1928, 99: 695. Also Arch. ges. Physiol, 1928-29, 221: 213.—Koopman, J. [The heart hormone] Geneesk. gids, 1929, 7: 768-75.—McDonald. C. H., & McDonald, A. C. Demoor's active substance of the heart. Proc. Soc. Exp. Biol, N. Y 1933 30: 786-8.-Miyagawa, Y. On the auto- hormon. Japan M. World, 1930, 10: 1-6.—Paes E Sur ,no'nglrlt,de^-suhstances a('tives du coeur. C. rend. Soc. biol, 1939 131: 0oL—Pal, J, Singer, R. [et al] Aussprache uber rierzhormonprapaiate. Med. Klin, Berl, 1928 24- 576 — Pavlenko, S. M. [Analysis of the so-called heart hormone] Med. biol. J, Leningr, 1928, 4: 93-100.—Podolsky, E. The heart hormone. Med. Times, Lond, 1931, 59: 20-2. Also J Med, Cincin, 1933, 14: 476-8.—Polak & Sumbal, J. I Unsolved problem of the cardiac hormone] Bratisl lek hsty 1930, 10: 215-26.—Posener. K. Ueber Herz- und Kreislaufhormone. Khn. Fortbild, 1933, 1: 627-61. Also in Neue deut. Klin, Berl, 1933, 11: 627-61.—Revers. F. E [Heart hormones] Medcd- R'Jks !nst- pharm. ther. onderzoek. 1931 4-18.—Rigler, R. Ueber den gegenwartigen Stand der rierznormonfrage. Mitt. Ges. inn. Med. Wien, 1927-28, 27: 22~5- „„ , T; Ueber wirksame Stoffe in Herzhormonprapara- ten. Med. Khn, Berl, 1928, 24: 574. ------ & Singer. R. Ueber das Herzhormon. Arch. ges. Physiol, 1928, 220: 56-' 68 Also Klin. Wschr, 1927, 6: 2357.—Rigler, R., & Tiemann, F. Ueber den Herzautomatiestoff. Ibid, 1928, 7: 553.—Rosin, H. Ueber Herzhormone. Deut. med. Wschr, 1928, 54: 1130-2.— Rothberger, C. J. Ueber Einwande gegen die Herzhormonlehre Med. Klin, Berl, 1931, 27: 1501.—Sterne, J. Le coeur, glande endocrine. Gaz. med. France, 1937, 44: 223-6.—Viale, G. Gli ormoni cardiaci. Rev. sudamer. endoer, B. Air, 1930, 13: 803-8.—Viton, A. Algunas consideraciones sobre hormonas cardiacas. Rev. As. mid. argent, 1932, 45: 939-42.—Zuelzer, G. Das Herzhormon; zugleich ein Versuch der Abgrenzung des Hormonbegriffes. Med. Welt, 1929, 3: 304-6. ---- Automatine [Zwaardemaker] Westenbrink, H. G. K, & Arons, P. Recherches chimiques sur l'automatine. Arch, neerl. physiol, 1929, 14: 394-406. ------[On heart automatin] Ned. tschr. geneesk, 1929, 73: 798-800.—Zwaardemaker, H. Radiation-substances and cardiac hormones. Proc. Akad. wet. Amsterdam, 1927, 30: sect, sc, 184-8. ------ Die Automatine als Strahlungs- stoffe im Herzen. Zschr. Kreislaufforsch, 1928, 20: 121-31. —--- Paradoxes et automatines. Arch, nierl. physiol, 1929, 14:407-17. ----— EquiUbres et automatines. Ibid, 565- 9L ------ [Automatines, produced by external irradiation, with automatines produced by internal potassium radiation] Ned. tschr. geneesk, 1927, 71: 1000-3. ------ [Exogeny and endogeny of the basic substance of automatines] Ibid, 1928, 72: 477. ------ & Arons, P. Sur l'origine de l'automatine. Arch, nierl.physiol, 1927-28, 12:520-8. ------ [Preparation of automatin, a hormone for automatic regulation of the heart] Ned. tschr. geneesk, 1927, 71: pt 2, 1111-7. ---- embryonal. Balogh, A. [Use of corhormon in surgery] Gyogyaszat, 1936, 76: 519.—Bugyi, B., & Hegediis, I. Beitrage zur chemi- schen Differenzierung der kreislaufwirksamen Muskelextrakte und des embryonalen Herzens (Corhormon) Zschr. Kreislauf- forsch, 1939, 31: 377-84.—Miko, G, & Toro, I. [Investiga- tions of the embryonal cardiac hormone] Gy6gy&szat, 1935, 75: 551-3.—Naszvadi, I. Die Beeinflussung des Herzmuskel- bestandes mittels embryonalem Herzhormon. Mschr. ungar. Med, 1938, 12: 45-7.—Purjesz, B., & Toszoghy, A. Ueber die Wirkung des embryonalen Herzhormons. Schweiz. med. Wschr, 1939, 69: 523.—Toro, I. [The effect of embryonal heart-extract on the heart muscle] Magy. orv. arch, 1936, 37: 232-56. Also Zschr. mikr. anat. Forsch, 1937, 41: 1-26. Also Orv. hetil, 1938, 82: 566. ------ Neue Untersuchungen zur Wirkung des embryonalen Herzextraktes. Arch. exp. Zellforsch, 1938-39, 22: 304-16.—Toszoghy, A. [Effect of fetal cardiac hormone] Orv. hetil, 1939, 83: 765-7. ---- Eutonon [Zuelzer] Rigler, R. Ueber den gegenwartigen Stand der Herzhormon- frage. Wien. med. Wschr, 1928, 78: 523.—Rubensohn, E. Ueber das Herzhormon Eutonon und seine Wirkungen. Med. Khn, Berl, 1930, 26: 1483.—Salomon, H, & Zuelzer, G. Ueber das aus der Leber gewonnene Herzhormon Eutonon. Zschr. ges. exp. Med, 1929, 56: 291-324.—Salzmann, F. Experimentelle und kUnische Beobachtungen iiber die Wirksamkeit von Padutin (Kallikrein) Lacarnol und Eutonon. Munch, med. Wschr, 1931, 78: 833-6.—Zuelzer, G. Das Herzhormon Eutonon. Med. Klin, Berl, 1927, 23: 1502. Also in Probl. biol. med. (Leontovich, A. V.) Moskva, 1935, 168-78.----— Zum gegenwartigen Stand der Herzhormonfrage. Med. Klin, Berl, 1928, 24: 571-4. ------■ Die klinische Bedeutung des Herzhormons Eutonon, zugleich eine Analyse der Reservekraft des Herzens. Ibid, 1930, 26: 695-8. Also Verh. Berl. med Ges. (1930) 1931, 61: pt 2, 4-11. ---- nodal [Hormocardiol of Haberlandt] Haberlandt, L. D;is Herzhormon. 64p. S? Jena, 1930. ---- Das Hormon der Herzbeweguiig. 57p. 8? Berl., 1927. Also Wien. klin. Wschr, 1926, 39: 1297. Also Biol, gen, Wien, 1927, 3: 549-56. Deloyers, L. Creation de nceud de Keith artificiel. Ann. physiol. Par, 1928, 4: 757-60.—Dcmoor, J. Contributions a HEART HORMONE 314 HEART HORMONE la physiologie g£n£rale du cceur; le teglage humoral dans le caur: action des substances actives de la tegion du nceud de l'oreillette droite. Arch, internat. physiol, Li£ge, 1924, 23: 121-52. ------ Les complexes humoraux dans le coeur: nctivites des substances actives d'origine nodale et de l'ac6tyl- eholine et de l'adrenaline. Ibid, 1938, 47: 209-44. Les complexes humoraux dans le coeur; role des substances actives d'origine nodale et des m6diateurs des nerfs. Bull. Acad. meU Belgique, 1938, 6. ser, 3: 216-39. ------ & Rijlant, P. Contributions k la physiologie gininde du cceur; les effets des substances actives du naud de Keith-Flack sur les oreillettes isol£es du lapin. Arch, internat. phvsiol, Li£ge, 1926, 27 : 1-21. Also Bull. Acad. med. Belgique, 1926, 5. ser, 6: 320-35.----— Role des substances actives d'origine nodale dans le teglage humoral du tissu contractile du caur. Arch, internat. physiol, Liege, 1936, 43: 460-91. Also Bull. Acad. mid. Belgique, 1936, 6. ser, 1: 212-44, 5 graph. Also C. rend. Soc. biol, 1936, 122: 443-5—Fachini, G. Ricerche sul mec- canismo urrcrale di correlazione intracardiaca; i principii attivi del nodo di Keith-Flack. Boll. Soc. ital. biol. sper, 1934, 9: 964-6.—Fahrenkamp, K. KUnische Beobachtungen mit dem Herzhormonprr'parat Hormocardiol nach Haberlandt. Med. Klin, Berl, 1929, 25: 338-43, 2 pl. ■----- & Schneider. H. Vergleichende Lntersuchungen mit einem als Hormocardiol bezeichneten Herzhormonpraparat und einem neuartigen Muskelextrakt. Ibid, 1930, 26: 48-50.—Haberlandt, L. Ein Hormon der Herzbewegung. Lmschau, 1926, 30: 735.------ Versuche rrit alkoholischen Froschherzextrakten. Arch. ges. Physiol, 1926, 212: 587; 214: 471.------ Leber die Unab- hangigkeit der Bildung des Herzerregungsstoffes vom sym- pathischen Herznervensystem. Ibid, 1927, 216: 789-95. ------ Bcstrahlungsversuche mit Fluorescenz-, LTtraviolett- und Rontgenlicht. Ibid, 218: 129-36. ------ Versuche mit einem Herzextrakt vom Warmbliiter. Ibid, 1928, 219: 279- 85. ------ Warmbliiterversuche mit dem Herzhormon- praparat. Ibid, 220: 203-11. ------ Weitere Frosch- lierzversuclie mit dem Herzhormonpraparat. Ibid, 1928-29, 221: 576-911. ------ Pharmakologie; Untersuchungen mit mit dem Herzhormonpraparat. Ibid, 1929, 222: 259-70. ------ Fortgesetzte Froschherzversuche mit dem Herz- hormonpraparat. Zschr. ges. exp. Med, 1929, 68: 185-95. ------ Weitere Warmbluterversuche mit dem Herzhormon- praparat. Arch. ges. Physiol, 1929, 222: 670-3.------ Neue Kaltbliiterversuche mit dem Herzhormonpraparat. Ibid, 223: 2S2-9. ------ Vergleichende Versuche mit einem Herzinuski lextrakt und einem Skelettmuskelextrakt vom Warnibluter. Ibid, 1930, 224: 741-8. ------ Versuche an der Magen-Darmmuskulatur des Kalt- und Warmbliiters. Ibid, 225: 384-8. ------ Versuche an Wirbellosen. Ibid, 541-57.------Versuche mit transplantierten Froschherzen. Ibid, 1931, 227: 709-14. ------ Weitere Untersuchungen an Wirbellosen: Versuche am Limulusherzen. Ibid, 228: 595-603. ------ Neue Herzhormon-Untersuchungen. Klin. Wschr, 1926, 5: 654; 1522. ------ Neue Herzhormon-Be- funde. Ibid, 1927, 6: 2099. ------ Ueber ein Kammer-, beziehungsweise Trichter-Hormon des Froschherzens. Zschr. Biol, 1926, 84: 143-52. ----— Ueber ein Herzhormon- praparat. Med. Klin, Berl, 1928, 24: 22. ------ Warm- bluterversuche mit dem Herzhormonpraparat. Ibid, 575. ------ Prinzipielles zur Herzhormon-Frage. Ibid, 577. ------ Weitere Versuche mit dem Herzhormonpraparat. Ibid, 1794. •------ Pharmakologische Lntersuchungen mit dem Herzhormonpraparat. Ibid, 1929, 25: 337. ------ Fortgesetzte Versuche mit dem Herzhormonpraparat. Ibid, 560. ------ Bemerkungen zur Arbeit von K. Fahrenkamp und H. Schneider: Vergleichende Lntersuchungen mit einem als Hormocardiol bezeichneten Herzhormonpraparat und einem neuartigen Muskelextrakt. Ibid, 1930, 26: 317. ------ Herzhormon-Lntersue'.iungen an Wirbellosen. Miinch. med. Wschr, 1930, 27: 1055. ------ The cardiac hormone. Med. J. & Rec, 1931, 133: 449; 499. Herzhormonpraparates. Med In Angelegenheit des Khn, Berl, 1931, 27: 388. Leber Einwande gegen die Herzhormonlehre. Ibid, 1248. ------ Herzhormon versuche mit transplantierten Froschherzen. Munch, med. Wschr, 1931, 28: 997. ------ Herzhormon-LTntersuchungen am Limulusherzen. Ibid, 1390. ----- Gewinnung und Nachweis des Herzerregungsstoffes (Herzhormons) In Handb. biol. Arbeitsmeth. (Abderhalden, E.) 1935, Abt. 5, T. 8, 237-44.—Laubry, C, Walser, J., & Deglaude, L. Les substances actives extraites du noeud de Keith et Flack exercent. sur le ca:ur isol6, une action comparable C. rend. Soc. biol, 1928, 98: 484-7.—Mitolo, M. Sull ormone cardiaco sinusale di Haberlandt. Boll. Soc. ital. biol. sper, 1938, 13: 696-8. Also Fisiol. & med, Roma, 1938, 9: 217-34 — Ponomarev, 1. I. [Depressor action of extracts from the Keith and Flack nudes according to Haberlandt] Tr. Leningr. nauch. prakt. farm, inst, 1935, 1: 116-22.—Rigler, R. Fortgesetzte Untersuchungen uber das Herzhormon; der wirksame Bestand- teil des Haberlandtschen Froschherzhormons. Arch, ges Physiol, 1928-29, 221: 509-25.—Waterman, L. Sur Taction des extraits du nceud de Keith-1 lack sur les veines isotees Arch, neerl. physiol, 1931, 16: 123 -31.—Weiss, R. F. Hormo- cardiol und Lacarnol. Med. Welt, 1931, 5: 1100-2. ---- Pharmacology. Binet, L, Verne, J., & Gabriel, P. Action des hormones cardiaques sur le cceur de poulet en culture in vitro. C. rend. Soc. biol, 1932, 110: 1262-5.—Deloyers, I, Action de l'extrait d'endocarde de mouton sur l'oreillette gauche isolfie do lupin; creation du nocu.l de Keith nrtificiel. Ibid, 1927, 97: 1828- 30.—Oemoor, J. Contributions k la physiologie generate du coeur; influence des substances extraites de l'oreillette et du ventricule du chien sur le caur isole du lapin. Arch, internat. physiol, Liige, 1922-23, 20: 29 14.------ Contribution k la physiologie generale du cuur; l'action des substances actives du cour du chien sur l'oreillette droite isolfie du lapin. Ibid, 110- 65.—Hiebaers, M. Le principe sensibilisant de l'extrait aqueux ou alcoolique du nosud de Taw-ua i mouton et bocuf) C. rend. Soc. biol, 1928, 98: 1242-4.— Hykes. O. V, & Hykc- 9CV1, D. E. Influence de l'extrait de coeur d'escargot sur le crjeur de la larve du moucheron. Ibid, 1932, 110: 391-4.— lonesco, D, & Bernard, A. T. Contribution k l'etude' des substances actives du cosur; l'hormone cardiaque. Arch. internat. physiol, Li6ge, 1928-29, 30: 267-79.—Jullien, A, Vincent, D. [et al] Action de divers extraits de coeurs de mollusques sur le cosur de grenouille. C. rend..Soc. biol, 1938, 127: 1495-7. ------ De l'action des extraits cardiaques sur l'automatisme du cceur chez Helix pomatia. Ibid, 129: 670-2, Effets des extraits cardiaques de mollusques gastero- podes sur l'automatisme du crjeur chez Helix pomatia. Ann, physiol. Par, 1939, 15: 858-62. ------ Contribution a l'etude de l'automatisme cardiaque chez les mollusques; action des extraits cardiaques sur le cceur d'Helix pomatia. J. phvsiol, path, g^n, 1939-40, 37: 937-50.—Kuhbacher. H. Wirkung von Gesamtherzextrakten bei Hunden. Wien. tierarztl. Mschr, 1938, 25: 530-4.—Lolli, N. Modificazioni ematiche indotte nell'uomo dai cosidetti ormoni cardiaci. Rass. ter. pat. clin, 1933, 5: 649-81.—Oana, M. Experimental study on heart function; influence on the function of extirpated toad heart of the skeletal muscle extract and potassium exposed to ultra- violet rays, roentgen rays and radium radiation, and the charac- teristics of the active substance contained in the alcohol extract of the skeletal muscle. Jap. J. Exp. M, 1932, 10: 123-55.— Okuno, T. Ueber die Autoregulation der Herzbewegungen; die Wirkung des Herzmuskelextraktes auf die Krotenherzbe- wegungen. Sc. Rep. Inst. Infect. Dis, Tokyo, 1926, 5: 447-70, 2 pl. ------ Ueber die Autoregulation der Herzbewegungen; die Wirkung des Herzmuskelextraktes auf die Meerschweiii- eheiiherzbewegungen. Ibid, 1927, 6: 353-63, 2 pl— Oppen- heimer, E. T. Studies of the so-called heart hormone. Am. .1. Physiol, 1929, 90: 656-67.—Orsi, A, & Pontoni, L. L'azione dell'acido adenilico sul cuore e sui vasi nei confronti della teoria dell'ormone cardiaco. Clin. med. ital, 1932, 63: 703-44 — Rigler, R, & Tiemann, F. Fortgesetzte Untersuchungen uber das Heizhormon; die Wirkung der substances actives. Arch. ges. Physiol, 1929, 222: -150-9.—Tyszka, C. Influence inhibi- trice des extraits du cceur du veau sur la sfictetion sudorale chez les tuberculeux. C. rend. Soc. biol, 1932, 110: 804.—Ulrica, V, & Rybak, J. [Study of mechanism of action of the heart hormone] Cas. 16k. Cesk, 1927, 66: 1010-4. ---- Therapeutic use. Deschamps, P. N. Un aspect nouveau de la question dea hormones cardiaques; les extraits musculaires en thdrapeutique cardioarterielle. Arch. mal. cceur, 1933, 26: 223-35.—Doren- dorf. Ueber Wert und Anwendung der Herzhormontherapie. Zschr. iirztl. Fortbild, 1934, 31: 619-21.—Farreras, P. El tratamiento de la angina de pecho y otras cardiopatfas por extractosde coraz6n. Rev. espafi. med. cir, 1931, 14: 119-21 — Korach. Die Herzhormon-Therapie. Prakt. Arzt, 1930-33, n. F, 16: 671-7.—Latzel, R. Ueber Verwendbarkeit der Herzmuskelextrakte in der Herztherapie. Wien. med. Wschr, 1931, 81: 518-20.—Maestrini, D. L'azione dell estratto atriale del cuore di mammifero su alcune cardiopatie dell'uomo: contri- buto alia miocardioterapia. Kinase med, 1928, 5: 1244-6.— Pennati, V, & Gasparird, A. Sul valore terapeutico degli estratti di cuore nelle cardiopatie. Rass. ter. pat. can, 1932, 4: 257-78, 5 pl.—Singer, R. Die praktischen Ergebnisse der Herz-Hormon-Therapie. Wien. klin. Wschr, 1931, 44: 39- 42.—Velden, R. von den. La terapeutica por la hormona cardfaca. Rev. med. germ. iber. amer, 1931, 4: 385-96. HEART hypertrophy. See also Heart, Size; Heart, Weight; Heart muscle, Tonus. Brack, E. Herzhypertrophie und plotzlicher Tod. Zschr. Kreislaufforsch, 1931, 23: 80-3.—Fitz, R. The case of James. J. Am. M. Ass, 1940, 114: 2161-7.—Frizon. Observation d'une hypertrophic du cceur. Observ. provenc. sc. med, 1823, 5: 78-82.—Paviot, J., Japiot, P. |et al] Essais de radioth6rapie sur la moelle osseuse chez des sujets presentant une hyper- trophic dite idiopathique du crjeur, accompagnee ou non dc polyglobulie. C. rend. Soc. biol, 1930, 105: 20-2.—Finney, G. L. Cardiac hypertrophy. Nebraska M. J, 1931, 16:464- 8.—Rogers, F. L, & Neely, J. M. Clinical pathological case reports. Ibid, 1934, 19: 187.—Roux, J. N. Observation et reflexions sur l'hypertrophie du caur. Observ. provenc. sc. med, 1823, 5: 3-8.—Tollman, J. P. Cardiac hypertrophy. Nebraska M. J, 1941, 26: 215-9.—Using digitalis. Ther. Notes, Detr, 1940, 47: 137-42. HEART HYPERTROPHY 315 HEART HYPERTROPHY ____ congenital, and idiopathic. See also Heart muscle, Glycogenosis. Casalis, A. *De l'hypertrophie cardiaque pure chez le nourrisson. 78p. 8? Par., 1936. Dumpert, F. *Ueber einen Fall von reiner kongenitaler idiopathischer Herzhypertrophie. 18p. 8? Wiirzb., 1936. Apert, E, Besson, & Baillet, M. Enorme dilatation cardia- nue cyptogenetique chez un enfant de 14 mois. Bull. Soc. ngdiat Paris, 1931, 29: 76-85.—Benjamin, B, & Simon, M. A. So-called congenital idiopathic hypertrophy of the heart. Am. J Dis Child, 1940, 59: 842-51.—Blechmann, G, Deberdt & Azouia'y R. Un nouveau cas d'hypertrophie cardiaque primi- tive. Arch. mid. enf, 1934, 37: 154-6—Broca, R, & Marie, J. Hvriertrophie cardiaque congenitale du nourrisson. In Ann6e pediat. (Broca, R, & Marie, J.) Par, 1936, 2: 27-37.—Cathala, J Sur un syndrome de myo-hypertrophie cardiaque primitive avec hvooplasie surtenale chez le nourrisson; myocardie. Bull Soc. mid. hop. Paris, 1927, 3. ser, 50: 1795-803.—Caussade, Watrin & Neimann. Etude anatomoclinique et histologique d'un cas d'hypertrophie cardiaque essentielle du nourrisson. Rev mid. Nancy, 1936, 64: 707-16.—Cordey, S. Contribution k 1'fHude de 1 hypertrophic du caur dite idiopathique et k celle des souff.es cardiaques dans la premiere enfance. Nourrisson, 1927 15: 147-56.—Costa. A. II comportamento del glicogene nei miocardio ipertrofico, studio sul metabolismo, l'essenza e il significato di ll'ipertrofia cardiaca. Sperimentale, 1929, 83: 605-38 —Croizier, L, & Poyuet. Hypertrophic cardiaque primitive. Loire mid., 1927, 41: 97-116.—Czyhlarz, E. Zur Kenntnis der kompensatorischen Herzmuskelhypertrophie. Wien. med. Wschr, 1930,80: 622.—Dammin. G. J, & Moore, R. A. Cardiac muscle in idiopathic hypertrophy of the heart in infancy and in normal growth. Arch. Path, Chic, 1939, 27: 122-7. Also repr.—Debre, R, & Broca, R. L'hypertrophie cardiaque essentielle et la mort subite chez le nourrisson. Bull. mid., Par, 1934, 48: 311-3. ------ & Soulie, P. Un cas d'hypertrophie cardiaque idiopathique. Bull. Soc. pgdiat. Paris, 1933, 31: 262-5.—Debre. R, & Busson, A. L'hyper- trophie cardiaque essentielle du nourrisson. Arch. m6d. enf, 1932, 35: 65-77.—Debre, R, Lamy, M, & Kaplan, S. Ln cas d'hypertrophie cardiaque congenitale. Bull. Soc. mid. hop. Paris, 1938, 3. ser, 54: 1033-8.—Debre, R, Marie, J, & Bernard, J. Hvpertrophie cardiaque congenitale. Arch. med. enf 1936, 39: 98-106. Also Bull. Soc. med. hop. Paris, 1935, 3 ser, 51: 995-1004.—Drexler. A. Sogenannte idiopathische Herzhypertrophie bei Sauglingen und Kindern. Ausz. Inaugur. Diss Med. Fak. Univ. Bern (1935-37) 1938, No. 213, 1-4 — Dufourt, A, & Vachon, A. L'hypertrophie cardiaque primitive de la premiere enfance. J. mid. Lyon, 1933, 14: 127-34.— Dumas, A, & Pipard. Un cceur de mille grammes par hyper- trophic primitive; syndrome clinique ayant pu faire penser a un infarctus du myocarde. Lyon mid., 1926, 137: 617. Elizalde, P. de. Corazon grande idiopatico. Arch, argent. pediat, 1933, 4: 88-94.—Enzer, N. Idiopathic cardiac hyper- trophy'with cor pulmonale. Am. J. Path, 1938, 14: 667.— Garrahan, J. P, & Traversaro, J. C. Sobre el diagnostico de la hipertrofia cardfaca congenita. Rev. As. med. argent, 1932, 45: 1604-9, pl—Gautier, P, & Schcenau, M. L hypertrophic cardiaque primitive chez le nourrisson. Rev. med. Suisse rom, 1931, 51: 635-40.—Holmes, G. W. Congenital idiopathic enlargement of the heart. Am. J. Roentg, 1931, 25: 320-3.— Jammet. L'hypertrophie cardiaque essentielle du nourrisson. Gaz. med. France, 1934, 115-9—Katz, G. Idiopathische Herzmuskelhypertrophie, eine konstitutionelle Erkrankung. Ther. Gegenwart, 1929, 70: 554-7—Kerley.C. G. Congenital heart with massive enlargement. Arch. Pediat, IN. Y, 1933, 50: 217.—Koenen, H. P. J. [Congenital hypertrophy of heart] Ned. tschr. geneesk, 1930, 74: pt 2, 6001.—Komeda, M, & Nishi, S. A study on congenital idiopathic hypertrophy ot the heart in a grown-up child. Orient. J. Dis. Inf., Kyoto, 1933, 13: 35 — Kretschmer, W. Allgemeine Bemerkungen zur vaso- kardiotropen Coffeinwirkung, zugleich ein Beitrag zur Lntste- hung der idiopathischen Herzhypertrophie. Deut. Arch. klin. Med, 1937, 180: 318-26.—Krstulovic, E. Zur Frage der idiopathischen Herzhypertrophie. Mschr. Kinderh, 1926, 33: H3_9 —Kugel, M. A, & Stoloff, E. G. Dilatation and hyper- trophy of the heart in infants and in young children with myo- cardial degeneration and fibrosis (so-called congenital idiopathic hypertrophy) Am. J. Dis. Child, 1933, 45: 828-64.-Light- wood, R, & Court, D. Cardiomegaly in an infant; idiopathic Proc. R. Soc. M, Lond, 1938-39, 32: Sect. Stud. Dis. Child, 316-8— MacMahon, H. E. Hypertrophy of the heart in infants. Am. J. Dis. Child, 1938, 55: 93-9.—Manca, C, Sulla ipertrofia di cuore idiopatica congenita. Cuore & circol 1936 20: 513-32.—Mansens, B. J. [Congenital large heart] Ned. tschr. geneesk, 1937, 81: 2122.—Mouriquand, G, Rertoye, P, & Charleux, G. Les hypertrophies du cceur chez le nourrisson. Arch. med. enf, 1926, 29: 83-91.—Mussliner, S. Beitrag zur sogenannten idiopathischen Herzmuskelhyper- trophie und zur essentiellen Hypertonic im Kindesalter. Zschr Kinderh, 1930, 50: 134-40.-Mutgeert B. L [Congenital large heart] Ned. tschr. geneesk, 1937, 81: 2121-Nuss- brecher, A. M. ?Idiopathic hypertrophy of the heart. Proc. R. Soc. M, Lond, 1934-35, 28: 151-3.—Oberhamnier, K. Zur Frage der angeborenen Herzvergrossening (idiopathische Herzhypertrophie) Zschr. Kreislaufforsch , 1927, 19: 441-52.— Pompe, J. C. Hypertrophic idiopathique du cceur. Ann. anat. path. Par, 1933, 10: 23-35.—Power, G. F, & LeCompe, P. M. Remarks on a case of congenital idiopathic hypertrophy of the heart. J. Pediat, S. Louis, 1938, 13: 760-71— Savage, J. J. A case of cardiac hypertrophy in an infant. Lancet, Lond, 1930, 1: 348.—Scott, A. J, & Zeiler, A. H. ( onsonital cardiac hypertrophy. Am. J. Dis. Child, 1926, 31: 31-3.—Sprague, H. B, Bland, E. F, & White, P. D. Congenital idiopathic hypertrophy of the heart: a case with unusual family history. Ibid, 1931, 41: 877-86. Also repr.—Stoloff, E. G. So-called idiopathic enlargement of the heart in infancy and in childhood. Ibid, 1928, 36: 1204-17.—Turquety, R. L'hypertrophie cardiaque essentielle du nourrisson. Gaz. mid. France, 1936, 43: 153-6.—Ullrich, O. Angeborene Herzhypertrophie mit Endokardfibrose bei zwei eineiigen Partner von mjinnlichen Drillingen. Zschr. menschl. Vererb, 1937-38, 21: 585-98 — Woodhouee, G. A. Congenital hypertrophy heart. Ohio M. J, 1927, 23: 666. ---- Decompensation. See also Heart dilatation; Heart failure. Bouchut, L, & Froment, R. Les gros coeurs par anoxtaiie; k propos des anemies pernicieuses compliqu6es d'hypertrophie et d insuffisance cardiaques. Arch. mal. coeur, 1934, 27: 325- 36.—Casorati, F. Cardiopatia; ipertrofia universale del cuore con dilatazione delle caviti prevalente nelle destre; restringi- mento d'ambidue gli orifici auricolo-ventricolari; edema ai piedi, indi anasarca, e spandimenti sierosi nelle pleure e nei peritoneo; apoplessia polmonare. Gior. progr. pat, Venez, 1846, ser. 2, 9: 397-426.—Dietlen, H. Probleme der Pathologie des Kreislaufes; Dilatation und Hypertrophie. Deut. med. Wschr, 1928, 54: 2006-10.—Eyster, J. A. F. Cardiac dilatation and hypertrophy. Tr. Ass. Am. Physicians, 1927, 42: 15-21.— Gillman, I. Studium tiber die Kapillarisierung des Myokardes bei Herzdilatation und bei Herzhypertrophie. Ausz. Inaugur. Diss. Med. Fak. Univ. Bern (1935-37) 1938, No. 180, 1.— Goette, K. Rontgenologische Befunde bei Herzhypertrophie und -Dilatation. Verh. Deut. Ges. inn. Med, 1929, 41. Kongr, 398-400.—Gonzalo, G. R. Distensiones y dilataciones cardia- cas. Siglo med, 1926, 77: 441.—Katsilabros, L. Le mecanisme de la production de l'hypertrophie type excentrique et de la dilatation primaire du coeur. Paris m6d, 1928, 67: 477-81.— Kirch, E. Pathogenese und Folgen der Dilatation und der Hypertrophie des Herzens. Klin. Wschr, 1930, 9: 7(i'J; 817. ------Dilatation und Hypertrophic des Herzens. Aerztl. Fortbild. Bad Nauheim, 1938, 14: 47-60.—McGunn, J. Surgi- cal treatment of the hypertrophie and dilated heart. Vet. J, Lond, 1936, 92: 6-9.—Mahaim, I. Des reactions volum6tri- ques du crjeur de l'hypertrophie k la dilatation. Ann. m6d. Par, 1928, 22: 79-92.—Pallasse & Didierlaurent. Hyper- trophie et dilatation 6norme du coeur. Lyon mid., 1938, 161: 12.—Podkaminsky, N. A. Entwicklung der Hypertrophie und der Dilatation des Herzens in Abhangigkeit von seinem funk- tionellen Bau; Rontgendiagnostik einer partiellen Hypertrophie und Dilatation. Virchows Arch, 1932, 284: 92-104.—Roesler, H. Cardiac hypertrophy and dilatation. In Cyclop. Med. (Piersol-Bortz) Phila, 1939, 3: 715-31. -----r Cardiac hypertrophy and dilatation, cardiac failure. In Diagn. Treat. Cardiovasc. Dis. (Stroud, W. D.) Phila, 1940, 1: 329-61 — Sanes, S, & Arnold, D. P. Dilatation and hypertrophy of the heart in infancy and childhood. Am. J. Dis. Child, 1936, 51: 479.—Sison, A. G, Gomez, L, & Santa Cruz, J. Z. Hyper- trophy and dilatation of the heart. J. Philippine M. Ass, 1941, 21: 211-3.—Vannotti, A. Die Capillarisierung und die Ernah- rung des Herzens und der grossen Gefasse unter normalen und pathologischen Bedingungen; die Capillardurchblutung des Myokardes bei der Dilatation und bei der Hypertrophie des Herzens. Zschr. ges. exp. Med, 1936, 99: 371-86. ---- Diagnosis. Burger, R. *Die Hypertrophie der Herz- kammern und das Elektrokardiogramm [Zurich] p.603-48. 8? BerL, 1925. Also Zschr. klin. Med, 1925, 102: Bohning, A, Katz, I. N. let al] The value and significance of multiple chest leads in man; normal and hypertrophied hearts. Am. Heart J, 1939, 18: 25-45.—Deindl, A. Elektro- kardiogrammstudien; die S-T-Strecke und die Nachschwankung bei Hypertrophiekurven; ein Vergleich der Hypertrophiekurven mit Schenkelblock- und Verzweigungsblockkurven. Deut. Arch. klin. Med, 1935-36, 178: 425-47—Eyster. J. A. E. Determination of cardiac hypertrophy. Tr. Ass. Am Physi- cians, 1928, 43: 18-22. Also Arch. Int. M, 1928, 41: 667-82 — Kalitovsky, E. F. [Method of determining hypertrophy of the heart] Klin, med, Moskva, 1929, 7: 692-711.—Kern, B. Der Hypertrophie-Index. Zschr. Kreislaufforsch, 1941, 33: 209; 279* 311 ------ Die Erkennung der Herzhypertrophie aus Ekg und Rontgenbild und ihre Messung. Ibid, 209-26.— Kienle F Vergleichende elektrokardiographische und morpho- lo«'isch'e Untersuchungen uber die Seitendiagnose von Herz- schadigungen und ihre Abgrenzung gegen Hypertrophie sowie Querlage. Arch. Kreislaufforsch, 1939 4: 19-48.—Koch- Momm, E. Liisst sich eine Herzhypertrophie aus dem Elaktro- kardiogramm diagnostizieren? Med. Vv elt, 1935, 9: 1219-21.— Nichols, C. F. Determination of cardiac hypertrophy. Abstr. Proc Ass. Life Insur. M. Dir. America, 1932, 19: 35-76. HEART HYPERTROPHY 310 HEART HYPERTROPHY ---- Etiology. See also under primary diseases as Anemia; Blood pressure, high; Erythremia; Heart valve, Disease; Myxedema, &c. Ho wet, H. *Hypertrophie et insuffisance eardiaques dans les an6mies chroniques graves. !»">p. 8° Lyon, 1934. Davis. D, & Blumgart, H. L. Cardiac hypertrophy; its relation to coronary arteriosclerosis and congestive heart failure. Ann. Int. M., 1937-38. 11: 1024-38. Also in J. H. Pratt Anniv. Vol, 1937. 557-71.—Jensen. F. G., & Norgaard. Studies on the functional cardiac diseases and the essential cardiac hvpertrophv, in normal pregnant women. Acta obst. gyn. scand, 1927, 6: 67-108.—Kahn, J. R, & Ingraham. E. S, jr. Cardiac hypertrophy and eoronarv arteriosclerosis in hypertension. Arch. Path.. Chic, 19-11. 31: 373-7.—Kami- kozawa. N. Leber die Hei/hypertrophic bei Klappenfehler. Tr. Jap. Path. Sue, 1924, 14: 122.—Kaplan. B. I, Clark. E, & De La Chapelle. C. E. A study of myocardial hypertrophy of uncertain etiology, associated with congestive heart failure, with consideration of the role of antecedent hypertension. Am. Heart J, 1938, 15: 582-96.—Kern, B. Das Verhalten des Hvpertrophie-Index unter verschiedenen physiologischen Redingungen. Zschr. Kreislaufforsch, 1941, 33: 279-89. ------Das Verhalten des Hypertrophie-Index bei Herz- und Kreislaufkrankheiten. Ibid, 311-32.—Levy, R. L, & Rousse- lot, L. M. Cardiac hypertrophy of unknown etiology in young adults; a clinical and pathological study of 3 cases. Tr. Ass. Am. Phys, 1933. 48: 125-49. Also Am. Heart J, 1933, 9: 178-95.—Levy, R. L, & Von Glahn, W. C. Further observa- tions on cardiac hvpertrophv of unknown etiology in adults. Tr. Ass. Am. Physicians, 1937, 52: 259-63.—Lurie, E. I, & Levin, E. R. [Hvpertrophy of the heart in hypothvreosis in children] Pediatria, Moskva, 1940, No. 2, 18-21.—Malattie (Ije) della vecchiaja; ipertrofia del cuore. Progr. ter, Milano, 1903, 146-8.—Matas, R, & Heninger, B. R. Reversible cardiac enlargement in a case of congenital cavernous heman- gioma. Am. Heart J.. 1939. 17: 131-7.—Nemet, G., & Gross, H. Cardiac hypertrophy in a case of Cooley's anemia. Ibid, 1936, 12: 352-7.- Paradiso, F. Su di un caso di eritremia cronica con ipertrofia del cuore. Arch. ital. pediat, 1932-33, I : 105-1S. pl.—Popper, L. Zur Frage der Herzhypertrophie bei Myocarditis. Schweiz. med. Wschr, 1939, 69: 559-61.— Reid, W. D. Spinal deformity as a cause of cardiac hvpertrophv. .1. Am. M. Ass, 1930, 94: 483. Also repr- Schmidt, L. E. C. Leber Hlutdiucksteigeruug und ihre Beziehung zur Muskel- ai teriolensklerose und Herzhypertrophie. Virchows Arch, 1938. 301: 336-8.- Willius. F. A. Clinic on cardiac hyper- Iropliv and failure secondary to dilluse, bilateral congenital cystic disease of the lungs. Proc. Mayo Clin, 1937, 12: 572-5. ---- Etiology: Exercise, and work. See also Heart disease, Etiology; Heart func- tion, Variation; Heart muscle, Fatigue. Borgard, W, & Hermannsen, H. Sporteignung, sportliches Training, Sportherz. Beitr. Khn. Tuberk, 1933-34, 84: 194- 205.—Brooks. H. The heart of the athlete. In Contr. M. Sc. (E. Libman) N. Y, 1932, 1: 227-40.—Cassinis, V. Modifica- zioni della grandezza del cuore dopo la corsa in militari in allenamento. Gior. med. mil, 1932, 80: 361-80.—Deutsch. Gibt es ein Sportherz und wie wird es diagnostiziert? Prakt. Arzt, Lpz, 1929, n. F, 14: 485-8.—Dmitrenko, L. F. [Heart and sports] Klin, med, Moskva, 1926, 4: 215-8.—Ellis, M. M, & Ellis, C. G. Electrocardiogram of athletes with cardiac hypertrophy. Am. J. Physiol, 1940, 129: 351.—Herxheimer, H. [Increase in size of heart by sport] Vrach. delo, 1926, 9: 1705-10. Also Khn. Wschr, 1927, 6: Sportarztl. Mitt, 21-3.— Hynek, K, Krai, J, & Bastecky, J. [Outlines of the heart in athletes] Cas. lek. Cesk, 1933, 72: 1113; 1151.—Kauf, E. Die Bedeutung der Sportherzvergrosserung. Wien. klin. Wschr, 1927, 40: 1401. •------ Bedeutung der Vergrosserung des Sportherzens. Med. Khn, Berl, 1928, 24: 40.—Kirch, E. Leber das Zustandekommen der physiologischen und patho- logi.-chen sogenannten Sportherzens. Zschr. Kreislaufforsch, 192S. 20: 132-57. ------ Herzkraftigung und echte Herz- hypertrophie durch Sport (an Hand neuer Sektionsfalle) Ibid 1936, 28: 893-907. ------ & Griinbauer, W. Ueber tier- experimentelle Herzhypertrophie bei Laboratoriumsratten durch trainingsmassiges Schwimmen. Beitr. path. Anat, 1937- 38. 100: 354-63.—Kirch, E, & Nurmberger, W. Entwick- lungsgang und Ruckbildung der sportliehen Herzhypertrophie im Tierversuch. Arch. Kreislaufforsch, 1939, 4: 1-18.— Podkaminsky, N. A. Beitrage zur pathologischen Arbeits- physiologie; das Herz des Lasttragers im Rontgenbilde. Arbeits- physiologie, 1928-29, 1: 306-56. ------ Existe-t-il une hypertrophie du cceur causae par le travail? Bull. Soc. radiol mid. France, 1930, 18: 373. ------ [The theory of the so- called working hypertrophy of the heart] Klin. med. Moskva 1936, 14: 1748-55.—Rautmann, H. Ueber das Sportherz' Med. Klin, Berl, 1935, 31: 148.5-7.- Reindell, H. Kyrao graphische und elektrokardiographische Befunde am Sport- herzen; Untersuchung in Ruhe. Deut. Arch. klin. Med, 1937- < v 181: 485-514.—Smith, H. L. Athletic heai i, an unfortunate term. Proc Mayo Clin, 1935, 10: 122. ---- experimental. Decherd, G. M, jr, Herrmann. G, it Schwab. E. H. Experi- mental hypertrophy without and with digiializaiion on creatine content of rabbit hearts. Proc Sue. l)\p. Mini. N. V, 1936, 34: 864-6.—Do Wesselow, O. L. V. S, A: Grifliths. YV. J. The role of the adrenal gland and of the raised metabolism in the produc- tion of organ hypertrophy in the thvroid-fed rat. Brit. J. Exp Path, 1938, 19: 347-53.—Doring, G. Ueber tierexpeiinientelle Erzeugung linksseitiger Herzhypertrophie durch Kphedrin- Ephetonin-Injektionen. Beitr. path. Anat., 1935 36, 96: 309- 25.—Drury, A. N, & Wightman, K. J. R. Observations relating to cardiac hypertrophy in the rabbit; its production by arterio- venous anastomosis. Q. J. Exp. Physiol. Lond, 1940, 30: 15-57.—Eyster, J. A. E. Experimental and clinical studies in cardiac hypertrophy. J. Am. M. Ass, 1928. 91: 1881 4. Also repr. -Herrmann, G, Decherd, G, & Erhard, P. Pioduction of cardiac hvpertrophy in rats. Proc. Soc. Exp. Biol, N. Y 1941, 47: 464.—Herrmann, G. R., & Musser, J. H. Experiment tal chronic pericarditis; further contribution to the study of cardiac hypertrophy. Ibid, 1927-28, 25: 314.—Kirch. Iv Ueber tierexperimentelle Erzeugung von tonogener Dilatation und Hypertrophie des rechten Herzens durch hochdosiertc Histamininjektionen. Arch. exp. Path, Berl, 1933, 171: 691 715.—Rytand, D. A., & Dock, W. Experimental concentric and eccentric cardiac hypertrophy in rats. Arch. Int. M, 1935 56: 511-20.—Shelley, W. B., & Code, C. F. ('blonde space in hypertrophied hearts of hyperthyroid rats. Am. .). Physiol 1941, 133: 444.—Watrin, J., & Francois, R. Hypertrophic experimentale du cieur dc cobave par injections r6p6tees de post- hypophyse. C. rend. Soc biol', 1937, 126: 357. ---- partial. Muller, H. R. *Untcrsuchungen iiber die Mediamuskulatur der Aorta bei linksseitiger Herzhypertrophie. 34p. 8? Wiirzb., 1926. Dunis, E, & Korth, C. Die typische Form der Linkshy- pertrophie im Elektrokardiogramm unte) dem Einfluss einer Amylnitritinhalation und einer Sauersl.ofTniangela Inning Deut. Arch. khn. Med, 1938-39, 183: 230--42. Holman, E. Hemicardiac hypertrophy due to increased peripheral resistance; a study of pulmonicand aortic stenosis experimentally produced. J. Thorac. Surg, 1939-40, 9: 262 73. Rijssel, E. C. van [Hypertrophy of the right heart] Ned. tschr. geneesk, 1929, 73: 2305-20.—Waider. J. Linkshypertrophie ohne Hochdruck oder Aortenvitium; ein Beitrag zur elektrokardiographischcn Diagnosestellung einer Linkshypertrophie. Deut. Arch. klin. Med, 1939, 184: 65-77. ---- Pathogenesis. La Rocha, E. de. *Le role de l'augmentation anormale de la pression moyenne dynamique dan.< la genese de l'hypertrophie cardiaque. 54p. 8°. Par., 1932. Bohnenkamp, H. Die Lehre von der Herzhypertrophie. Khn. Wschr, 1929, 8: 433-9.—Herrmann. G, & Decherd, G. M., jr. Some studies in the mechanism of cardiac hyper- trophy. Ann. Int. M, 1939-40, 13: 794-806.------' The pathogenesis of cardiac hypertrophy. Bull John Sealv Hosp, Galvest, 1939, 1: 82-5.—La Franca, S. Le modificazioni del tono e delle cavite del cuore; l'ipertrofia cardiaca. Cult. med mod. Pal, 1927, 6: 439-51.—Pal, J. Ueber die konzen- trische Hypertrophie des Herzens und die toxogene Hypertonic. Khn. Wschr, 1935, 14: 116-9.—Roberts, S. R. Temporary or reversible hypertrophy of the heart. Bull. Fulton Co. M. Soc, 1936, 10: No. 21, 5.—Watrin, J. Sur le mecanisme de l'hyper- trophie cardiaque. C. rend. Soc. biol, 1936, 122: 1095. ---- Pathology. Otto, O. *Ueber das braune Pigment im hypertrophischen Herzmuskel [Wurzburg] p.611-25. 8? Berl., 1932. Also Virchows Arch, 1932, 283: Costa, A. Comportamento del glicogene miocardico nei riguardi del metabolismo e del significato dell'ipertrofia cardiaca. Pathologica, Genova, 1929, 21: 573-5.—Cowan, D. W. Crea- tine content of the heart in experimental cardiac hypertrophy. Proc Soc Exp. Biol, N. V, 1934, 31: 417— Decherd, G, Schwab, E. H. [et al] Creatine content of hypertrophied rabbits heart muscle. Ibid, 1935-36, 33: 521.—Dock, W. the capacity of the coronary bed in cardiac hypertrophy. J. ?nP' Mii 19£-' 74/ 177-80- Also » pr. -Dogliotti. G. C, 4 Allara, *,. Ricerche sulla fine nrorazione del cuore umano ipertrofico. Cuore & circol, 1939, 23: 199-523.—Drury. A. N. Observations relating to cardiac hypertrophy in the rabbit; the refractory period of hypertrophied ventricular muscle. Q. J. Exp Physiol, Lond, 1940, 30: 59-64.—Gross, H. Water content of the myocardium in hypertrophy and chronic con- gestive failure. J. Lab. Clin. M, 1939-40, 25: 899-914 — Hitchings, G. H, & Wearn, J. T. Electrolyte changes in hypertrophying rabbit heait. J. Biol. Chem, 1941, 140: Proc, 01— JelinghoflT, W. Das Abnutzungspigment im Herzen unter besonderer Beriicksichtigung des hypertrophischen und HEART HYPERTROPHY 317 HEART MUSCLE des atrophischen Herzens. Beitr. path. Anat, 1936, 98: 80-9.— Ludewig, S, & Chanutin, A. The lipoid phosphorus content of hypertrophied hearts and kidneys in the rat. J. Biol. Chem, 1936, 115: 327-32.—Lumiere, A, & Grange, R. H. Hyper- trophie du cceur et hemolyse. C. rend. Soc biol, 1929, 100: 349.—Roberts, J. T., Wearn, J. T, & Badal, J. J. The capillary- muscle ration in normal and hypertrophied human hearts. Proc. Soc. Exp. Biol, N. Y, 1938, 38: 322.—Roberts, J. T., Wearn, J. T, & Boten, I. Quantitative changes in the capillary muscle relationship in human hearts during normal growth and hypertrophy. Am. Heart J, 1941, 21: 617-33.—Rosenow, E. C, jr, & Smith, H. L. Extreme cardiac hypertrophy; a report of 44 cases in which the heart weighed 800 gm. or more. Minne- sota M., 1939, 22: 739-43.—Russow, E. Die Blutversorgung b\ pertrophischer und atrophischer Herzen. Zschr. Kreis- laufforsch, 1936, 28: 41-51.—Schwab, E. H, Herrmann, G, it Connally, J. F., jr. Experimental ablation of posterior as i-oiitrasted to anterior aortic cusp on cardiac hypertrophy in the rabbit. Proc. Soc. Exp. Biol, N. Y, 1935-36, 33: 410-2.— Shipley, R. A, Shipley, L. J, & Wearn, J. T. The capillary supply in normal and hypertrophied hearts of rabbits. J. Exp. M, 1937, 65: 29-42, 2 pl. Also repr.—Strong, G. F, & Munroe, D. S. Cardiac hvpertrophy; 42 hearts weighing 750 grams or more. Ann. Int. M, 1939-40, 13: 2253-64—Vandor, F. [The variation of the size of the nuclei in the heart muscle in cases of the hypertrophy of the heart] Magy. orv. arch, 1939, 40: 295-308.—Wearn, J. T. Alterations in the heart accom- panying growth and hypertrophy. Bull. Johns Hopkins Hosp, 1941, 68:363-74. --- in animals. Bouchet. Hypertrophie du cceur gauche chez une jeune chien. Bull. Acad. vit. France, 1928, 1: 168.—Cowan, D. W, & Bauguess, L. C. Myohemoglobin content of the hyper- trophied heart of the anemic rat. Proc. Soc. Exp. Biol, N. Y, 1936, 34: 636.—Herrmann, G. The heart of the thoroughbred race horse; studies in hypertrophy. Ibid, 1928-29, 26: 549- 51.—Norr. Hochgradige Herzhypertrophie, Erweiterung des arteriellen Systems und Extrasystolie bei einem Pferde. Berl. tierarztl. Wschr, 1922, 38: 393-6. HEART-LUNG preparation. See also Heart, isolated. Bornstein, A, & Roese, H. F. Das innervierte Herz- Lungen-Nieren-Pra*iaiat. Arch. ges. Physiol, 1932, 229: 182-6.—Brull, L. Preparation heart-lung k sang coagulable. 0. rend. Soc biol, 1936, 121: 1351-3.—Evans, C. L, De Graff, A. C. [et al] The utilization of blood sugar and lactate by the heart-lung pu pa ration. J. Physiol, Lond, 1933, 80: 21-40.— Koreisha, L. A. [Innervated cardio-pulmonaiv preparation] Sovet. klin, 1934, 20: 43-6.—Landis, C, Hunt, W. A. [et al] Color and super-high-speed cinematography of the isolated heart-lung. Am. J. Physiol, 1940, 129: 400.—Waters, E. T, Fletcher, J. P, & Mirsky, I. A. The relation between carbon- hydrate and 0-hydroxybutyric acid utilization by the heart- lung preparation. Ibid, 1938, 122: 542-6. HEART muscle. See also Heart; Heartbeat; Heart conduction, &c. Fiddes, J. Studies on the cardiac muscle of lower verte- brata. Q. J. Exp. Physiol, Lond, 1928-29, 19: 243-72 — Izquierdo, J. J. A study of the crustacean heart muscle. Proc. R. Soc, Lond, 1931, ser. B, 109: 229-51. Also Arch. lat. amer. card, Mex, 1931-32, 2: 229-48.—Ramsay, A. M. An analogy between the intrinsic muscles of the eye and the muscle of the heart. Glasgow M. J, 1940, 134: 115-25— Robb, J. S., & Robb, R. C. Abnormal distribution of the superficial muscle bundles in the human heart. Am. Heart J, 1938, 15: 597- 603—Stensen, N. On the muscular nature of the heart, transl. by M. N. Walsh. In Cardiac Classics (Willius, F. A.) S. Louis, 1941, 104, facs.—Strickland-Goodall, J. The myocardium. Canad. M. Ass. J, 1927, 17: 881-6.—Sulzer, R. Die mechani- schen Eigenschaften des Herzmuskels. Zschr. Biol, 1931-32, 92: 545-54.—Tamura, M. Studies on the heart muscle. Jap. .1 M. Sc, Tokyo, 1931, 2: No. 2, Tr, Biophys, 21. --- Abscess. See also subheading Rupture. Rosenthal, E. *Plbtzlicher Herztod durch Spontanruptur infolge Muskelabszess. 25p. 8°. Kiel, 1927. Imhoff, J. D., & Martin, T. Absceso estreptoc6ccico del tabique interventrfculo-auricular; sfndrome del absceso del tabique interventrfculo-auricular. Dfa mid., B. Air, 1938, 10: 656-9.—McLagan, F. A case of abscess of the heart causing death through coronary haemorrhage. Lancet, Lond, 1928, 2: 279.—Oehl. Herzabszesse. Deut. tierarztl. Wschr, 1929, 37: 87.—Oilier. Abces du myocarde; pericardite et pleuresie gauche purulentes; abces du rein. Bull. Soc. anat. Paris, 1913, 88: 334-6.—Stevenson, G. H, & Marshall, A. J. Rupture of the heart from a pyaemic abscess in the myocardium. Glasgow M. J, 1928, 110: 337-40.—Weiss, S, & Wilsins, R. W. Mvo- cardial abscess with perforation of the heart. Am. J. M Sc 1937, 194: 199-205, 2 pl ---- Aging. See also Heart disease, Age relationship; Heart failure, Etiology. Cohn, E. A. The aging of the heart muscle regarded from a general biologic point of view. Am. J. M. Sc, 1929, 177: 619 39.—Dagnini, G. L'elettrocardiogramma nell'eta senile: variability individuale. Arch, pat, Bologna, 1933-34, 13: 78-112, ch.—Dogliotti, G. C. Modificazioni nello spessore delle fibre del miocardio umano nelle varie eta. Boll. soc. ital. biol sper, 1931, 6: 31-3. ------ Trasformazioni strutturali dello stroma del miocardio in rapporto all'eta. Monit. zool. ital , 1931, 41: Suppl, 293-9. Also Verh. Anat. Ges, 1931, 39: }^~P\ ~.----- La struttura del miocardio dell'uomo nei vari individui e nelle varie etk; ricerche di anatomia microscopical del miocardio su 200 cuori normali in rapporto alia senescenza ed alia costituzione individuale. Zschr. ges. Anat, 1. Abt, 1931, 96: 680-722. ------& Amprino, R. La distanza tra le strie intercalari del miocardio umano nelle varie etk. Monit. zool. ital, 1931, 42: 44-52.—Duthoit, A, Warembourg, H, & Pinchart. L'61ectrocardiogramme du vieillard. Arch. mal. cceur, 1938, 31: 34-45.—Gelman, I., & Brown, S. Electro- cardiographical characterisation of the heart in old age and in childhood. Acta med. scand, 1937, 91: 378-96.—Hoskin, T. J. The senile heart; its effect on the operative risk. Clin. J, Lond, 1932, 61: 445-51.—Jundell, I, Svedenius, G., & Bjerlov, H. Besonderheiten des Herzens im Kindesalter. Acta paediat, Lpps, 1941, 28: 130-72.—Kaldova, A. [Chronic insufficiency of the myocardium in old age] Cas. 16k. Cesk, 1938, 77: 610-2.—L, P. B. Corazon (El) senil y su tratamiento. Dfa med, B. Air, 1931-32, 4: 727.—Lane, L. L. The manage- ment of the senile heart. Hahneman. Month, 1934, 69: 840- 8.—Strukov, A. I. [Peculiarities of the specific muscular system of the heart in chUdren and adolescents] Tr. Vseross. Konf. patologov (1934) 1935, Moskva, 159-66.—Warnecke, B. Elektrokardiographische Untersuchungen anscheinend Herz- gesunder, die das 65. Lebensjahr uberschritten haben. Zschr. Kreislaufforsch, 1939, 31:391-401. ---- All or none phenomenon. Burridge, W. The cardiac all or none law. Q. J. Exp. Physiol, Lond, 1928-29, 19: 215-7.—Rijlant. P. Le tout ou rien du cceur. C. rend. Soc. biol, 1926, 95: 224-7.—Rojansky, N. [The law of all or none in its application to cardiac activity | Vrach. delo, 1927, 10: 1065-9.—Roos. J. [The theory of the al! or none] Tschr. diergeneesk, 1928, 55: 154-76.—Zwirkster, G. H., & Boyd, T. E. Reversible loss of the all or none response in cold blooded hearts treated with excess potassium. Am. J. Physiol, 1935, 113: 560-7. ---- Amyloidosis. Thiele, W. H. *Ueber Herzamyloid [Heidel- berg] 37p. 8? Furtwangen, 1932. Binford, C. H. Primary amyloid disease of the myocardium and blood vessels; report of a case with death from myocardial failure. Hosp. News, Wash, 1940, 7: No. 10, 13-9, 6 fig — Budd, J. W. Primary amyloid disease of the heart; report of a case. Am. J. Path, 1934, 10: 299-307, 4 pl—Kerwin, A. J. Idiopathic amyloid disease of the heart. J. Lab. CUn. M, 1936-37, 22: 255-61.—Larsen, R. M. A pathological study of primary myocardial amyloidosis. Am. J. Path, 1930, 6: 147-59, 3 pl. ---- Aneurysm. See also Heart, Bloodvessels; Heart auricle, Dilatation, &c. Janowitz, M. *Beitrag zum Herzaneurysma [Berlin] 43p. 8? Charlottenb., 1937. Schlichter, J. *Beitrag zu den Aneurysmen und Rupturen des Herzens. 58p. 23cm. Lau- sanne, 1940. Bacaloglu, C. L'anevrisme parietal du coeur. Arch. mal. cceur 1930, 23: 81-94.—Barjon & Mathieu. Anevrysme du coeur. Lyon mid., 1940, 164: 153-5.—Bartsch, G. H, & Posselt, A. Ueber aneurysmaartige Ausbuchtungen der Fossa ovalis in den rechten Vorhof und ein ungewohnlich gelegenes Aneurysma der Unken Herzkammer. Frankf. Zschr. Path, 1933-34 46: 358-75.—Berk, L. H. Cardiac aneurysm. Am. Heart J, 1939, 17: 569-80.—Berlin, R, & Hallen, L. Ein Fall von Herzaneurysma mit seltener Lokalisation. Acta med. scand, 1938, 95: 34-48.—Bischoff, L. Ein instruktiver Fall von Herzwandaneurysma mit Gigampfisymptom. Schweiz. med. Wschr, 1938, 68: 1415.—Brams, W. A, & Gropper, A. Cardiac aneurysm; an evaluation of its cUnical features. Illi- nois M. J, 1940, 78: 246-52.—Braunbehrens, von. Die Herzmuskelschwiele und das Herzwandaneurysma. Verh. Deut. Rontg. Ges, 1934, 27: 15 [Discussion] 21—Brunetti, L. Sull'aneurisma cronico parziale del cuore di origine traumatica. Riv radiol, 1931-32, 4: 669-84.—Burnford. Aneurysm of HEART MUSCLE 318 HEART MUSCLE heart. West London M. J, 1922, 27: 95.—Castex. M. R., & Battro, A. Aneurisma cr6nico del coraz6n; comprobaciftn tier lApsica. Rev. Soc. med. int., B. Air, 1931, 7: 89-100.— Christiansen, H. [Aneurysma cordis] Hospitalstidende. 19:10, 79: [Dansk radiol selsk. forh.] 5-7.—Crespo Aharez, A. Ane\risme des parois du cceur. Arch. mal. caur, 1931, 21: 465-77—Gouto, M. Aneurysmas arterio-venosos da base do coracao. In his Clin, med, Rio, 1935, 2: 65-72, 4 pl.—Dar- dinski, V. J. Unusual cardiac pathology. Am. J. Clin. Path.. 1941 11: 754-60.—Dressier. W. Zwei Falle von Herz- aneurysma. Mitt. Ges. inn. Med. Wien, 1935, 34: 189.------ & Pfeiffer, R. Cardiac aneurysm; a report of 10 cases. Ann. Int. M, 1940-41, 14: 100-21.—Dumifrescu-Mante, Hagiescu .- Kirschmann, K. Herzanem v-ma. Fortsch. Ront- genstrahl. . 1927, 36: 668.—Laves, VV. Plotzlicher Tod durch Ruptui eines Herzaneurvsmas im friihen Kindesalter. Wien. klin. Wm In . 1929, 42: 1469.—Levine, V. Aneurysm of the heart. In Path. Conf. (Jaffe, R. H.) Chic, 1940, 728-30 — McRcbert, G.R, & Reddy, D. G. Disappearance of an extra- thorncic aneurysm. Brit. J. Surg, 1940-41, 28: 144-7 — MiiflVi, W. E. Rarissimo caso de aneurysma cardiaco. Ann. Fac med. S. Paulo, 1934, 10: 353-63, 3 pl—Mahaim, I. Deux cas d'an6vrisme infectieux du caur avec lesions destruc- tives du faisceau auriculo-ventriculaire sans bradycardie. Ann. anat. path. Par, 1927, 4: -188-505.—Mendoza-Guazon, M. P. Aneurvsm of the heart. J. Philippine Islands M. Ass., 1925, 5: 137-41.—Moia. B, & Batlle, F. F. Aneurisma cardi- aco. Rev. argent, card, 1938, 5: 268-71.—Morris, L. M. Cardiac aneurysms. Am. Heart J, 1927, 2: 548-59.— Nishida, H. A c::-c of aneurvsm of ihe heait. Policlin. Dairen, 1924-26. 2: No. 3 1. 1. Also J. Client. M, Dairen, 1925-26, 4: 60.— Palla«e, Hret A; Ouzel. G. Anevrvsme du occur; complcxe ventriculaire anormal. Lyon med., 1927, 139: 698-700.— Parade, G. W. Aneui \ sinatische Elongation des Herzens. Med. Min, Berl, 1934, 30: 1357-9.—Parkinson, J, Bedford, I). K, & Thomson. W. A. R. Cardiac aneurvsm. Q. J. Med.. Oxf., 1938, 7: -155-78, 5 pl. Also Brit. J. Radiol, 1939, 12: 129-49.—Pfeiffer, R, & Dressier, W. Herzaneurysma. Milt Ges. inn. Med. Wien. 1< 35. 34: 171.— Plesmann, K. Beitrag zur Pathogenese des Aneurxsma dissecans. Zschr. Kreis- laufforsch, 1930, 22: HS9 -98. pl -Poix, G, & Thoyer. G. AnSvrisme du coeur. Presse med., 1937, 45: 997. Also Gazz osp, 1938, 59: 212.—Poje, L. [Aneurysms of the heart] Polska gaz. lek, 1938. 17: 629; 65s. Ramaeli;.. P. Sloiia di aneurisma di cuore. Filiatre sebe/.io. Nap, 1836, 11: 83 8.— Regebberger, H. Ein typischer 1 all von Herzaneurysma. Rontgenpraxis, 1934, 6: 806-1 I.—-Reydeilet. Observation sur un an6vrisme du coeur, anterieui k la naissance; accompagne' de ph£nomenes particuliers et dont il n'est pas fait mention dans les auteurs. Observ. provenc sc. med, 1822, 3: 229-33. Also Med. lbera, 1931, 15: pt 2, 31-6.—Shennan, T, & Niven, W. LnusiKillv large cardiac aneurvsm. J. Path. Bact, Edinb, 1925. 28: 390-2, pl—Sigler, L. H, & Schneider, J. J. The diagnosis of cardiac aneurysm with report of 2 cases Ann. Int. M, 1934-35, 8: 1033-46.—Sternberg, C. Leber das Herzaneurysma. Wien. med. Wschr, 1933), 83: 1249.— Strandell, B. [Case of aneurvsm of heart] Sven. lak. tidn, 1930, 27: 636-44-Thomas, W. S. R. A case of aneurysm of the heart. Lancet, Lond, 1930, 1: 405—Tillich, A. Per- foration eines mykotischen Aneurysmas bei Lthmusstenose. Rontgenpraxis, 1941, 13: 184-6.—Veiga de Carvalho. H. Consideracoes amitomo-patologicas em torno de dois achailo- d'uma necroscopia; aneurisma calcificado do coracao; ectopia renal. Ann. paul med. cir, 1933, 25: 349-66.—Vogt, W. Herzaneurysma. Rontgenpraxis, 1937, 9: 498-500.—Vulpe, I. [Congenital cardiac aneurysm] Omsk. med. J, 1926, 1: 2; 45.—Wiberg, G. A ease of aneurysm of the heart. Acta radiol, Stockh, 1931, 12: 562-73. ---- Aneurysm: Diagnosis. Mazer, A. E. *Etude radiologique de l'anevrysme parietal du coeur. 49p. 8? Par., 1933. Albrecht. H. U. Rontgenologisch diagnostiziertes und autoptiscl lestatigtes Herzaneurysma. Zbl. inn. Med, 1932, 53: 557-62.—Benedetti, P. La diagnosi dell'aneurisma cronico del cuore. Arch, pat, Bologna, 1928, 7: 393-408.__ Bergonie & Muulinier. Anfrvrysme parietal du cceur: diag- nosti.n.e par l'c\anien radioscopique. Arch. Slectr. med 1923. 33: 65 8.-Boller. R, & Pape, R. Zur Diagnose des Herzaneurysma.-. 1 oitsch. Rontgenstrahl, 1932, 45: 318-27 — Brenner, F, & Wachner, G. Leber einen ungewohnlichen Sitz eines Herzanemvsmas und seine Rontgendiagnostik. Ibid, 1936, 54: 243-8.—Clerc, A. Contribution au diagnostique clini.iue de l'anevrisme i aiietule du coeur. Cas. 16k. cesk, 1937, 76: 691-5. Galifi, I, I 'uignosi radiologica di aneurisma cronico del cuore (cont'enna necroscopical Radiol, med, Milano, 1937, 21: 760 8. Ghorardini, G. Sulla diagnosi clinica dell'aneurisma cronico parzialo del cuore di origine arteriosa. Cuore & circol, 1927, II: 111 79. Glazova, O. I. [Diagnosis of heart aneurysm] Klin, med, Moskva, 1938, lfi: 1355-66.—Golonsko, R. Ein kasuistischer Beitrag zur Erkenn- barkeit des Herzaneun sinus im Rontgenbilde. Rontgen- praxis, 1929, 1: 69-1-6.—Gonzalez Sabathie. I, Sulla diagnosi di certe forme d'aneurisma intrnperieiudico. Moll. Accad. med. Roma, 1935. 61: 221-5. —Groedel, F. M. Der ront- gcnologische Nachweis des Herzaneurysmas. Miinch. med. Wschr, 1933, 80: 210.---Ivanov. N. V. [Diagnosis before death of thrombus and embolism of the coronaries and aneurvsm of the right and left heart] Vrach. gaz., 1929, 33: 379-84.— Kali^ch, Z. Ueber einen radioskopisch diagnostizierten und autoptisch bestiitigten Fall von partiellem Hei zancun sina Wien. klin. Wschr, 1927, 40: 1078. Melcharl. F. Herz- aneurysma, in vivo (liagiiostiziert und autoptisch be-taiu'i Rontgenpraxis, 1929, 1: 877 81.—Mentl. S. Pseudo-auevrisme du coeur; symphyse pcricardicpie; contribution au diagnostic differentiel de l'anevrisme du cceur dans l'image radioscopique. Arch. mal. cceur, 1931, 24: 417 21.—Nordenfelt, O. The electrocardiogram in chronic aneurysm of the heart. Acta med. scand, 1939, 102: 101 -23.—Scherf, D, & Erlsbacher, O. Zur Symptomatologio des partiellen Herzaneurvsmas. Med. Klin, Berl, 1934,^30: 1687-9.—Semerau-Siemianowski. M. Du diagnostic clinique de l'anevrisme parifetale du coeur. Cas. 16k. cesk, 19.37, 76: 733-8.—Steel, D. The roentgen diagnosis of cardiac aneurysms. J. Am. M. Ass, 1931, 102: 432-6.—Strindell, B. A contribution to the diagnosis of aneurysm of the heart. Acta med. scand, 1930, 74: 148-85. ---- Atrophy. See also subheading Aging. Bruno, G. Studio sul miocardio atrofico; le strie intercalari. Ricer. morf, 1933-34, 13: 411-5.—Katz, L. N, Saphir, O, & Strauss, H. The electrocardiogram in brown atrophy of the heart. Am. Heart J, 1934-35, 10: 542-5— Malattie (Le) della vecchiaja; atrofia del cuore. Progr. ter, Milano, 1903, 150.—Willius, F. A. Cardiac clinics; clinic on atrophy of the heart; carcinoma of the stomach with marked inanition. Proc. Mayo CUn, 1938, 13: 615-7. ---- Automatism. See under Heartbeat. ---- Bathmotropism. See subheading Excitability. ---- Blood vessels. See also Coronary vessels. Jores, A. *Das Verhalten der Kapillaren des Herzens in Systole und Diastole [Kiel] 16p. 8? Borna, 1927. Biondo, A. II rapporto vaso-parenchimale nei miocardio di alcuni mammiferi. Endoer. pat. cost, Bologna, 1930, n. ser, 5: 115-38.—Blinkoff, J. Die Kapillarisierung des Myokardes in der Systole und in der Diastole. Ausz. Tnaugur. Diss. Med. Fak. Univ. Bern (1935-37) 1938, No. 208, L— Correia. M. The role of the extracardiac arteries in the myocardial circula- tion. S. Afr. M. J, 1939, 13: 811.—Odel, H. M. Structural changes in the arterioles of the myocardium in diffuse arteriolar disease with hypertension group 4. Arch. Int. M, 1940, 6fi: 579-602—Petren. T., & Sylven, B. Der Einfluss der Gravi- ditit auf die Kapillarenanzahl in der Herzmuskulatur. Morph. Jahrb, 1936, 78: 643-8. ----— Die Kapillarisierung der Herzmuskulatur beim Meerschweinchen. Ibid, 1937, 79: 200-8. ------ Weitere Untersuehungen uber den Einfluss des Trainings auf die Kapillarisierung der Herzmuskulatur. Ibid, 80: 439-44.—Sylven, B. Weitere Lntersuchungen uber die totale Anzahl der Blutkapillaren der Herz- und Skelett- inuskulatur unter verschiedenen phvsiologischen Verhaltnissen. Verh. Anat. Ges, 1938, 45: 163-8— Thelen. A. Die venose Blutstauung im Herzmuskel. Virchows Arch, 1937, 300: ---- Calcification, and ossification. Brown, C. E, & Evans, W. D. Primary, massive calcifica- tion of the myocardium. Am. Heart J, 1940, 19: 106-13.— Cohen, J. N, & Levine, H. S. Calcification of myocardium with bone formation; report of a case. Arch. Int. M, 1937, 60: 486-93.— Diamond, M. Calcification of the myocardium in a premature infant. Tr. Chicago Path. Soc, 1932, 14: 64-74. Also Arch. Path, Chic, 1932, 14: 137.—Geipel, P. Zur \erkalkung der Herzmuskolfaser. Fortsch. Rontgenstrahl, 1926, 34: 311-6.—King, V. lie P. Focal calcification of heart muscle; ease report. Ann. Int. M, 1928-29, 2: 936-40.— Lenkeit, W. Zur Kenntnis der Herzmuskel verkalkungen beim Kalbe. Arch. wiss. prakt. Tierh, 1927, 56: 348-71.—Moore, i'er o M>'.?cardlal calcification. Am. J. Roentg, 1934, 31: 760-9.—Norr, J. Massensterben von Lammern durch Herz- niuskelverkalkung mit dem klinischen Befund von Extra- HEART MUSCLE 319 HEART MUSCLE svstolcn. Arch. wiss. prakt. Tierh, 1938-39, 74: 25-38 — Petrov V S. [Certain clinical data in ossification of the heart muscle'in'the horse] Sovet. vet, 1940, 17: No. 8, 94.—Red- fearn J A. Massive calcification of the myocardium; report of a case. Am. Heart J, 1936, 12: 36577—Richter, M. N. An unusual case of myocardial calcification with subsequent infection. Arch. Path, Chic, 1938, 26: 5S2- Tscherniak, W S & Voronzov, S. Zur Frage der Herzmuskeh erkalkungen bei Haustieren. Virchows Arch, 1929, 274: 154-69. ----■ Chemistry. See also subheading Metabolism. Alburn, H. E, & Myers, V. C. The creatine, phosphorus, and collagen content of different sections of the dog heart. J. Biol. Chem, 1939, 131: 713-6. Also repr.—Anrep, G. V, Barcoum. G. S, & Talaat, M. Liberation of histamine by the heart muscle. J. Physiol, Lond, 1936, 86: 431-51— Beattie, F, Milroy, T. F. let all 1De nucleotide component of mam- malian cardiac muscle; the composition and chemical properties of the nucleotide; the biological and co-ferment properties of the cardiac dinucleotide. Biochem. J, Lond, 1934, 28: 84- 93.—Bernard, A, & Richard, A. Sur la teneur et la repartition du potassium dans le myocarde. C. rend. Soc. biol, 1932, 110: 837—Bierry, H, & Gouzon, B. Dosage du gh/cog£ne dans le coeur d'Helix pomatia. Ibid, 1930, 104: 594.—Chang, I. Effect of asphyxia on the adenosinetriphosphate content of the rabbit's heart. Q. J. Exp. Physiol, Lond, 1938-39, 28: 3-13.— Cowan, D. W. The creatine content of the myocardium of normal and abnormal human hearts. Am. Heart J, 1934, 9: 378-85.—Decherd, G. M, jr, & Blum, J. E, jr. Phosphorus fractions in human heart muscle. Proc. Soc. Exp. Biol, N. Y, 1938, 38: 341-3.—Evans, G. The glycogen content of the rat heart. J. Physiol, Lond, 1934, 82: 408-80.—Fieschi, A. Experimentelle Beeinllussung der chemischen Zusammen- setzung des Herzens; Athvreoidismus, Thvreotoxikose, Adre- nalin. Klin. Wschr, 1932, 11: 1472.—Fujii, T. Leber ein eigenartiges Lipoid im Herzmuskel. Tr. Jap. Path. Soc, 1925, 15: 83.—Herrmann, G, & Decherd, G. Further studies in the chemistry of heart muscle. Tr. Ass. Am. Physicians, 1937, 52: 85-91.—Jullien, A, Vincent, D. [et al] Observations sur l'acetylchohne et la choline-esterase du coeur des mollusques. Ann. physiol. Par, 1938, 14: 567-74.—Kapeller, R, & Kul- schera-Aichbergen, H. Leber den Calciumgehalt des Herz- muskels. Biochem. Zschr, 1928, 193: 400-8.—Kisch, B. Die chemische Spezifitat des Herzmuskels. Klin. Wschr, 1935, 14: 145.—Klauer, H. R. Versuche zum Lipoidnachweis im Herzmuskel Frankf. Zschr. Path, 1926, 34: 65-70.—Klenk, E. Ueber Phosphatide; iiber die Sphingomyeline des Herz- muskels. Zschr. physiol. Chem, 1933, 221: 67-72.—Lasch. F. Ueber den Gesamtkohlehydratgehalt des Herzmuskels. Zschr. ges. exp. Med, 1932, 83: 36.—Linegar, C. R, & Myers, V. C. Further studies on the creatine content of heart muscle. Proc. Soc. Exp. Biol, N. Y, 1934-35, 32: 1016-8.—Loeper, M, Lemaire, A, & Tonnet, J. L'amylase du cceur. C. rend. Soc. biol, 1929, 103: 211.—Loewi, O. Ueber den Adrenalingehalt des Saugerherzens. Arch, internat. pharm. dyn. Par, 1937, 57: 139.—Lohmann, K, & Schuster, P. Ueber das Vorkom- men der Adenin-Nucleotide in den Geweben; Herzmuskulatur. Biochem. Zschr, 1935, 282: 104-8.—Long, C. N, & Evan?, G. T. Glycogen content of the rat heart. Proc. Soc. Exp, Biol, N. Y, 1932, 30: 186-9.—Manai, A. Comportamento istologico del glicogeno nei cuore di feto di carnivoro. Boll. Soc. ital. biol. sper, 1935, 10: 975-7.—Matsumori, T. Ueber die Verbreitung des Glykogens im Rinderherzen. J. Biochem, Tokyo, 1929, 11: 219-23.—Michelazzi, A. M. Tiroxina, castra- zione, atropina e glicogeno cardiaco. Pathologica, Genova, 1932, 24: 623.—Noll, A, & Becker, M. Der Glykogengehalt der Muskulatur und des Erregungsleitungssystems des Herzens nach chemischen und mikroskopischen Untersuchungen. Virchows Arch, 193.5-36, 296: 443-7.—Pace, L. Ricerche sulla distribuzione del glicogeno nei cuore dei bovini con particolare riguardo al tessuto specifico. Arch. sc. biol, Bologna, 1932-33, 17: 447-62, ch.—Pohle. K. Ueber das Vorkommen von Muskeladenylsaure und Hexosemonophos- phorsaure (Lactacidogen) im Herzen. Zschr. physiol. Chem, 1929, 184: 261-4.—Raab, W. Chemical determinations of the adrenocortical hormones in the heart muscle of the rat. Endocrinology, 1941, 29: 564-73.—Seecof, D. P., Linegar, C. R, & Myers, V. C. The difference in creatine concentration of the left and right ventricular cardiac muscles. Arch. Int. M, 1934, 53: 574-93.—Sehrt, E. Die Lipoide des Herz- muskels (die interstitiellen Korner Kolliker des Sarcoplasma) Zbl allg. Path, 1928, 43: 97-101.—Straub, F. B. Isolation and properties of a flavoprotein from heart muscle tissue. Biochem. J, Lond, 1939, 33: 787-92.------ Crystalline lactic dehydrogenase from heart muscle. Ibid, 1940, 34: 483-6, pl.—Tiemann, F. Ueber die Quellungseigenschaften des Herzmuskels unter verschiedenen Bedingungen. Zschr. ges. exp. Med, 1927-28, 58: 819-33.—Vincent, D., & Jullien, A. La teneur en acetylcholine du coeur des mollusques. C. rend. Soc. biol, 1938, 127: 334-6.—Vladimirov, G. E. Beitrage zur kolloidchemischen Charakteristik der Myosine und Myo- stromine aus dem Herzen. Biochem. Zschr, 1930, 222: 135-49.—Vollmer, H. Untersuchungen iiber den Kreatin- und Phosphorsauregehalt verschiedener Herzteile. Zschr. ges. exp. Med, 1929, 65: 522-34.—Weicker, B. Ueber den Chemis- mus des tiitigen Herzmuskels. Arch. exp. Path, Berl, 1933-34 174: 383-404.—Winter, L. B. A note on the cardiac inositol of the sheep, pig and ox. Biochem. J, Lond, 1940 34- 249 — Yater, W. M, Osterberg, A. E., & Hefke, H. W.' Chemical determination of the glycogen ratio in the bundle of His and the cardiac muscle in man and in the horse. Arch. Int M 1930, 45: 760-71—Zwaardemaker, H. Ueber die Strahlungs- stofte im Herzen. Arch. ges. Physiol, 1927, 218: 354-73. ---- Chordae tendineae. See also Heart valve. Frizzi, L. Una forma estremamente rara di corda tendinea dell atno sinistro del cuore. Cuore & circol, 1929, 13: 459- 77.—Jiiger, O. Eine seltene Herzmissbildung im Lichte der Spitzer'schen Theorie (Ursprung von Sehnenfaden der linken Zipfelklappe an einem Papillarmuskel im rechten Ventrikel) Beitr. path. Anat, 1928, 80: 29-39.—Natali, C. Inserzione anomala della muscolatura ventricolare sul pizzo aortico della valvola mitrale. Arch. ital. anat, 1928, 25: 439-52. ---- Chordae tendineae: Rupture. See also Heart muscle, Papillary muscle. Albertini, A. von. Ein Gutachten uber eine traumatische Sehnenfadenzerreissung der Mitralis mit todlicher Mitral- insufhzienz. Schweiz. med. Wschr, 1938, 68: 861-3.—Fron- thingham, C, & Hass, G. M. Rupture of normal chordae tendineae of the mitral valve. Am. Heart J, 1934, 9: 492-9.— Kis°ane, R. W, & Koons, R. A. Rupture of the chordae tendineae of a normal mitral valve: case report. Ohio M. J . 1938, 34:303. ---- Chronotropism. See Heartbeat, Automatism. ---- Contractility [Inotropism] See also Heart arrhythmia. Blum, H. F. The recovery of contractility after contraction in cardiac muscle. Am. J. Physiol, 1927, 82: 157-69.— Boer, S. de. Der enge Zusammenhang zwischen Contractilitat und Erregungsleitung (Erregbarkeit) ein kontrahierender Teil des Herzmuskels kann wahrend verschiedener Stadien des Kontraktionszustandes eine Erregungswelle (Kontraktions- welle) entsenden. Arch. ges. Physiol, 1928, 220: 220-33.— Dubuisson, M. Au sujet du nombre d'ondes qui constituent l'ionomyogramme de la contraction. Arch, internat. physiol, LiSge, 1934-35, 40: 291-3.—Dungern, M. Alterations in duration of isometric contraction, ejection time, systole and Q-T interval Am. Heart J, 1941, 22: 841 (Abstr.)—Estable, C. Intensidad, velocidad y energia de contraccion de las fibras del miocardio; relaciones matematicas de la velocidad de expulsion de la sangre por los dos ventriculos. Rev. Soc. argent, biol, 1934, 10: Suppl, 236-60, 2 pl Also Arch. urug. med, 1935, 6: Suppl, 139-61.------& Vaz Ferreira, A. Etude, in vivo, des types de contractions fasciculaires du coeur des vertebr's. C. rend. Soc. biol, 1931, 107: 1553-6.—Eyster, J. A. E, & Meek, W. J. The sequence of fractionate contrac- tion at different surface regions on the right auricle and ven- tricles of the dog's heart. Am. J. Physiol, 1941, 134: 513-6.— Fogelson, L. I, & Chernogorov, I. A. [Inotropic function of the heart and the electrogram] Med. biol. J, Leningr, 1928, 4: No. 6, 15-23.—Frank, O. Die Kontraktionen von Sinus, Atrium und Ventrikel des Froschherzens. Zschr. Biol, 1936, 97: 78-92.—Fredericq, L. Les differentes formes de la contrac- tion du myocarde ventriculaire. Arch, internat. physiol, liege, 1929, 31: 264-71.—Gewin, J. [Peristalsis of the heart] Onderzoek. Physiol. Lab, Utrecht, 1906, 5. ser, 7: 190-280, 3 pl.—Goss, C. M. Slow-motion cinematographs of the contraction of single cardiac muscle cells. Proc. Soc. Exp. Biol, N. Y, 1931, 29: 292. ------ Protoplasmic move- ment in cardiac muscle during interval between contractions. Ibid, 1939, 40: 16-8.—Katz, L. N. Observations on the dy- namics of ventricular contraction in the heart-lung preparation. Am. J. Physiol, 1927, 80: 470-84.—Kupalov, A. A. [Fourth heart function; its contractility] Sovet. vrach. gaz, 1934, 38: 422-4.—Lee, H. M. Summation of contractions in the turtle heart. Proc. Soc. Exp. Biol, N. Y, 1933, 30: 716.—Mac- pherson, W. E, Essex, H. E, & Mann, F. C. The rate of dis- appearance of glycogen during contraction of the perfused heart of the rabbit. Am. J. Physiol, 1932, 99: 429-32.— Rothberger, C. J. Die Dynamik der Herzkontraktion. Wien. med. Wschr, 1927, 77: 1683; 1719.—Sachs, H. Ueber den Erregungs- und Kontraktionsablauf am Herzen. Deut. med. Wschr, 1929, 55: 1497-501.—Segall, H. N, & Anrep, G. V. The isometric contraction of the frog's ventricle. Heart, Lond, 1926, 13: 61-75.—Siegel, R, & Unna, Z. Ueber die Zerlegung der Aktionsstromkurve des Herzens in chemische Teilphasen; Kontraktionen ohne Nachschwankung im Elektro- kardiogramm. Klin. Wschr, 1931, 10: 171.—Witting, V., Markowitz, J, & Mann, F. C. The role of glycogen in the contraction of the perfused heart of the rabbit. Am. J. Physiol, 1930, 94: 35-40. ---- Contractility: Alternation [Hypodynamia] See also Heart-block; Heart failure; also in 3. ser. Pulse, alternative. HEART MUSCLE 320 HEART MUSCLE Chini, V. L'alternanza del cuore; problemi di fisiopatologia e di clinica. p.715-101S. 8? Roma, 1935. Kisch, B. Der Herzalternans. 214p. 8°. Drosd., 1932. Polmailloux, M. *Le pouls alternant (etude clinique et essai de pathogenie) 233p. 8? Par., 1930. Spuhler, O. *Ueber Pulsus alternans mini- mus [Zurich] 16p. 8° Wiirzb., 1934. Also Zschr. klin. Med, 1934, 127: 268-80. Almeida Toledo, P. J. de, & Codespoti, A. Um caso de pulso altemante com deficit de 50' i. Rev. med, S. Paulo 1929-30, 14: No. 52, 42-9, 3 diagr.—Battro, A, & Quirno, N- Alternancia circulatoria; consideraciones sobre un caso de alternancia cardfaca auricular y ventricular acompanada de pulso alternante. Rev. argent, card, 1936-37, 3: 267-77 — Bellido, J. M. Nota sobre la gfinesi del ritme alternant en la granota. Ti. Soc. biol, Barcel, 1915. 3: 94-6, pl— Benatt, A. Hemisystolia cordis. Zschr. klin. Med.. 1929, 110: 207-15.— Hoer, S. de. Leber die periodisch inaquale Herztatigkeit. Zscln. Kreislaufforsch, 1932, 24: 575.—Calo, A. Systoles fiactioimees basculantes terminales chez I'homme. Arch. med. coeur, 1936. 29: 59-71.—Carter, F, P.. & Faulkner, J. M. Changes in conduction in the presence of alternation of the heart. Bull. Johns Hopkins Hosp, 1928, 42: 245-63 — Chini, V. Contribution a l'etude de I'alternance du coeur. Aieli. mal. cceur, 1928, 21: 90-103. ------ Delia particolare azione tossica esplicata sul cuore isolato di anfibi da alcuni sieri patologici; contributo alia conoscenza dell'alternanza del cuore. Bull. Accad. med. Roma, 1933, 59: 54-8. \ttuali indirizzi nello studio del problema dell'alteranza del cuore. Cuore & circol, 1936, 20:377-92. ------& Stefanutti, P. Osservazioni cliniche e ricerche sperimentali sull'alternanza del cuore. Ibid, 1934, 18: 443-70.—Fabre, P. Action excita- t rice des pulsations alternatives ttes breves teduites & une seule periode. C. rend. Soc. biol, 1939,131:251-4.—Fischer, R. Leber Pulsus alternans bei partiellem Schenkelblock. Klin. Wschr, 1933, 12: 1901-3.—Fredericq, H. La pathogenie du pouls alternant. Biol, med. Par, 1913, 11: 353-69.—Galata, G. Su di un caso di alternanza cronotropa e inotropa. Cuore & circol, 1928, 12: 152-64.—Gallavardin, L, & Gravier, I, Des moyens de d6celer I'alternance du pouls; alternance -pli\nmomanom6trique, osciUometrique et bidigitale. Lyon med, 1912, 119: 1144-51. ------ De la frequence des ex-" trasystoles ventriculaires retardees dans le coeur alternant; leur importance dans le diagnostic du pouls pseudo-alternant et de l'ipuisement mvocardique. Bull. Soc. med. hop. Lyon, 1914, 13: 286-90.- Goodhart, J. The pulsus alternans. Lancet, Lond, 1915, 1: 1203. —Greiwe, J. I. Klinische Be- obachtungen iiber Pulsus alternans. Zschr. Kreislaufforsch, 1934. 26: 497-503.- Hamburger, W. W, Katz, L. N, & Saphir. O. Electrical alternans; a clinical study with a report of 2 neciopsies. J. Am. M. Ass, 1936, 106: 902-5.—Hosslin, von. Lebei den Pulsus alternans. Berl. kUn. Wschr, 1909, 46: 1550. Joachim, G. Das Elektrokardiogramm des Pulsus alternans beim Menschen. Munch, nierl Wschr, 1911, 58: 1950-2.- Kahn, R. H, & Starkenstein, E. Die Storungen der Herztatigkeit durch Glyoxylsaure (Pulsus alternans) im Elektiokardiogramm. Arch. ges. Physiol, 1910, 133: 579-96, 3 pl— Katz. L. N, & Feil, H. S. CUnical observations on the dynamics of ventricular svstole; pulsus alternans. Am. J. M. Sc, 1937. 194: 601-10, 2 pl—Kisch, B. Der Calciumalternans; ein Beispiel des Alternans bei svstolisch disponiertem Herzen. Zschr. ges. exp. Med, 1929, 64: 666-79. —^— Gibt es einen isolierten elektrischen Alternans? Zschr. Kreislaufforsch, 1931, 23: 729-34.—Kisthinios, N„ & Gomez, D. M. Sur le mecanisme et la pathogenie de 1 alternance du pouls. Arch. mal. coeur, 1931, 24: 410-6.------Sur le traitement de l'insuffisance cardiaque chez les sujets ptesentant de I'alter- nance du pouls. Presse med, 1931, 39: 1026.—Laubry, C. A propos du pouls alternant. Arch. mal. coeur, 1931, 24: 744. ----— Sobre la patogenfa del pulso alternante. Ars medica, Barcel, 1935, 11: 93-102.------ & Poumailloux, M. I. alb inance dlectrique. Arch. mal. cceur, 1930, 23: 456-72.— Laubry. C, : 2149-52.—Rodriguez Sarabia, L„ & Velasco y Castellanos, R. de. El pequefio diastole general del coraz6n. Cr6n. med. quir. Habana, 1934, 60: 176-83.—Scherf, D, & Zdansky. K. Rontgenkymographische Schreibung von echtem Herzalternans beim Menschen. Fortsch. Rontgenstrahl, 1929, 40: 60-3. Sodeman, W. A. Alternation of the heart. Am. J. M. Sc., 1939, 197: 118-29.—Somer, E. de. Quelques observations sur l'alternance, specialement aptes injection d'adrenaline d'apres des experiences sur le coeur du chien in toto. Cardi- ologia, Basel, 1937, 1: 159-85.—Strasburger. Die Kurven eines Falles von echtem Pulsus alternans. Sitzber. Natur. Ver. preuss. Rheinl. Westphal, 1910, Bonn, 1911, B. 29.—Thomp- son, W. P, & Levine, S. A. Pulsus alternans; a note on certain factors influencing prognosis. Am. Heart J, 1936, 11: 135-9.— Titov, B. P. [Determination of irregular and alternating pulse by Korotkov's method (arterial tones)] Med. biol. J, Leningr, 1928, 4: 30-7.—Trabucchi, E. Su di una attivite alternogena per il cuore di rana esplicata dalla urina. Boll. Soc. ital. biol. sper, 1933, 8: 697-701.—Ukolova, M. [Mechanism of the origin of alternating contractures of the heart] J. Physiol. USSR, 1941, 30: 103-8.—Varisco, A. II polso alternante. Gazz. med. ital, 1914, 65: 261-4.—Velde, E. van de. Eiti- seitige linksventrikulare Lokalisation des Pulsus alternans mittels Rontgenkymographie. Fortsch. Rontgenstrahl, 1939, 59: 349-52.—Wiggers, C. J. The dynamics of ventricular alternation. Ann. CUn. M, 1926-27, 5: 1022-7. ----- The cause of temporary ventricular alternation following a long diastoUc pause. Proc. Soc. Exp. Biol, N. Y., 1926-27, 24: 386. Also in Contr. M. Sc. (A. S. Warthin) Ann Arb, 1927, 65-82.—Willius, F. A. Talk on pulsus alternans. Proc. Mayo Clin, 1936, 11: 496.—Windle, J. D. The pulsus al- ternans. Lancet, Lond, 1915, 1: 1262.—Wolfer, P. PuIsuh alternans und Herzinsuffizienz. Schweiz. med. Wschr., 1930, 60: 531-4.—Yamaguchi, T. The investigations of the pulse alternans. Acta Scholae med. Univ. Kioto, 1931, 14: 151-62.— Zarday, I. Schwangerschaft mit Herzalternans und gutem Ausgang. Zbl. Gyn, 1938, 62: 2102-6. ---- Contractility: Variation. Jeannopotjlos. J. L. *L'anisosphygmie res- piratoire k l'etat physiologique et pathologique. 76p. 25#cm. Par., 1938. Stein, W. H. *Untersuchungen an falschen Sehnenfaden des Saugetierherzens; Einfluss von Reizpausen und Herzmitteln auf die Kontrak- tilitat [Berlin] p.97-108. 8? Munch., 1930. Also Zschr. Biol, 1930, 90: Bisceglie, V. Sull'attivita contrattile degU espianti di cuore embrionale in condizioni normaU e sotto l'innuenza di alcuni ormoni. Arch. sc. biol. Nap, 1929, 13: 53-72 — Brown, D. E. S. Temperature and the responsive mechanism of cardiac muscle; temperature and the duration of contraction. J. Exp. Biol, Lond, 1930, 7: 373-84.—Edwards, D. J, & Cattell, McK. The action of compression on the contraction of heart muscle. Am. J. Physiol, 1930, 93: 90-6.—Funada, M. Versuche mit einer neuen Methode zur Registrierung der Vorhof-Kammerkontraktion am isolierten Froschherzen; Versuche uber den Einfluss der Pharmaka auf den zeitlichen Verlauf der Vorhof-Kammerkontraktion. Fol. pharm. jut... 1926, 2: [Brev.] 16.—Galata, G. Volume di afflusso diastolic■„ e contrattiUte potenziale del cuore. Cuore & circol, 1931, 15: 41-54.—Guerra. De Taction renforcatrice des extraits pau- cteatiques sur la force des contractions cardiaques. Arch. internat. physiol, Liege, 1924, 23: 153-62.—Katz. L. N. The relation of initial volume and initial pressure to the dynamics of the ventricular contraction. Am. J. Physiol, 1928, 87: 348-58.—Kisch, B. Dirlerenzierende Wirkungs- analysen von Heizgiften; die Wirkung zweiwertiger Kationen auf die Kontraktilitat des Froschventrikels. Arch. exp. Path, Lpz, 1930, 148: 150-63.- Kruta, V. Variations de la dutee de la contraction du muscle cardiaque en fonction du HEART MUSCLE 321 HEART MUSCLE rvthme et de la temperature. C. rend. Soc biol, 1937, 125: 498-501 ------ Effets des variations du calcium sur la contraction du myocarde etudiee en fonction du rythme et de la temperature. Ibid, 1938, 129: 791-5. ------& Zadina. R. Recherches sur la pharmacodynamic du muscle cardiaque; influence de l'adrenaline et de la tyramine sur la contraction du myocarde. Arch, internat. pharm. dyn. Par, 1938, 59: 198-211.—Marceau, F. Sur les modalites de la contraction du cceur chez quelques poecilothermes. Ann. physiol. Par, 1934, 10- 843-9.—Matsunaga, K. Dynamische Untersuchung der He'rzkontraktion; der Einfluss der Fullungsdruckveranderung auf das in einer HerzmitteUosung befindliche Froschherz. Acta Scholae med. Univ. Kioto, 1929, 12: 375-93.—Matuoka, S On the effect of temperature upon the potassium-contracture of heart. Nagoya J. M. Sc, 1936, 10: 275-9.—Veil, P. Essai sur la nature et l'expression de la contraction ventriculaire isolee et group6e k l'etat normal et pathologique. J. med. Lyon, 1936, 17: 787-99.—Wiggers, C. J. Are ventricular conduction changes of importance in the dynamics of ventricular contraction? Am. J. Physiol, 1927, 80: 12-30. ------ A study of the direct effect of hypercapnia on the contraction of the mammalian ventricle. Ibid, 1929, 90: 230-41.—Yasuoka, T. On the relation between the intraventricular pressure and the volume of the frog heart; analysis of the volume curve of heart contraction. Acta Scholae med. Univ. Kioto, 1929, 12: 347-54. ---- Contusion. See under Heart, Injury. ---- Cyst. Yamauti, M. Seltener FaU einer FUmmerepithelzyste im Herzmuskel. Gann, Tokyo, 1940, 34: 85. ---- Degeneration. See also subheadings Amyloidosis; Fatty degeneration; Myomalacia, &c; also under names of primary diseases. " Derichs, H. *Die Wirkung der Digitalis auf die relative Systolendauer bei Myodegeneratio cordis. 15p. 21cm. Bonn, 1938. Konigs, G. *Die relative Systolendauer bei Myodegeneratio cordis im Elektrokardiogramm. 16p. 21cm. Bonn, 1938. Alves de Almeida Cardoso, R. Degenerescencia basofila da fibra muscular cardiaca. Mem. Inst. Oswaldo Cruz, 1940, 35: 495-510, 3 pl.—Blumer, G, & Nesbit, R. R. A case of hemo- chromatosis with degeneration of the heart muscle and death from congestive heart failure. N. England J. M, 1938, 218: 295-8.—Brandis, W. Herzmuskelentartung oder Bleiver- giftung? Med. KUn, Berl, 1929, 25: 1552.—Euken. Harno- perikardium und Myodegeneratio cordis albumina et adiposa. Deut. tierarztl. Wschr, 1929, 37: 328.—Gouley, B. A, Bellet, S, & McMillan, T. M. Idiopathic myocardial degeneration of pregnancy and the puerperium. Tr. Coll. Physicians Philadelphia, 1935, 4. ser, 3: 52. Also Am. J. M. Sc, 1937, 194: 185-99, 2 pl—Haumeder, M. E. BasophiUc degeneration of heart muscle. Am. J. Path, 1935, 11: 535-40, pl—Jagic, N. Die Diagnose Myodegeneratio cordis. Wien. med. Wschr, 1932, 82: 17-9.—Kalter, S. Ueber Glykokollbehandlung degenerativ-dystrophischer Herzmuskelerkrankungen. Deut. med. Wschr, 1936, 62: 1371-3. Also Fortsch. Ther, 1934, 10: 608-10.—Karsten. Ueber die vielortUche Herzmuskelentar- tung bei Schweinen. Deut. tierarztl. Wschr, 1931, 39:338-40 — Liebegott, G. Ueber die basophile Degeneration der Herz- muskelfaser; ein Beitrag zu den vitalen Reaktionen. Beitr. path. Anat, 1936-37, 98: 410-24, 2 pl—Moore, H. Myo- cardial degeneration. Irish J. M. Sc, 1939, 6. ser. No. 165, 688-91.—Paige, B. H. A pecuUar type of myocardial degenera- tion. Proc. N. York Path. Soc, 1926, 26: 92-6.—Plette, J. G. [BasophiUc degeneration of the cardiac muscle] Ned. tschr. geneesk, 1937, 81: 3198-200.—Reisinger, J. A, & Blumenthal, B. Myocardial degeneration with hypertrophy and failure of unknown cause. Am. Heart J, 1941, 22: 811-24—Wischno- witzer, E. [Relation of the transverse dimension of the heart to that of the thorax, and the configuration of the heart in degeneration of the heart muscle] Warsz. czas. lek, 1936, 13: 648; 672.—Zafirian, V. A. [Electrocardiography during sub- cutaneous injections of COs in rabbits with experimental myodegeneration of the heart] J. Physiol. USSR, 1938, 25: 146-9. ---- Development. Benninghoff, A. Ueber die Entwicklung der Muskelarchi- tektur im Innern der menschUchen Herzkammern. Morph. Jahrb, 1929, 63: 208-42.—Bruno, G. Istogenesi del mio- cardio ed origine dei capiUari e dei sinusoidi nei cuore dell'uomo. Boll. Soc. biol. sper, 1926, 1: 97-100. Also Arch. ital. anat, 1928, 25: 320-403.—Gyory, B. Die Verteilung des Glykogens in dem Herzmuskel wahrend der Entwicklung. Verh. Anat. Ges, 1939, 47: 255-9, 3 pl—Matuda, K, & Odani, S. Hi- stologische Untersuchungen uber die fotalen Herzmuskeln beim Menschen. Jap. J. Obst, 1935, 18: 25-34.—Shaner, 227475—vol. 7, 4th series----21 R. F. The development of the muscular architecture of the ventricles of the pig's heart, with a review of the adult heart and a note on two abnormal mammalian hearts. Anat. Rec, 1928, 39: 1-16, 9 pl. Also Canad. M. Ass. J, 1929, 20: 386-90. ---- Dilatation. See Heart dilatation. ---- Disease [Myocardosis] See also Heart disease; Heart failure, con- gestive; Heart rheumatism. Segre, R. Le malattie del miocardio. 482p. 8? Bologna [1932] Arrillaga, F. C, & Espejo Sola, J. Consideraciones sobre miocardia. Sem. med, B. Air, 1932, 39: pt 2, 1613-24.— Assmann, H. Ueber Storungen des Herzmuskels. Deut. med. Wschr, 1937, 63: 921-7.—Borman, M. C. Diseases of the heart muscle. West Virginia M. J, 1929, 25: 267-75 — Bullrich, R. A. Miocardia. Rev. Soc. med. int., B. Air, 1927, 3: 442-57. Also Sem. med, B. Air, 1927, 34: pt 2, 948-53.—Buswell, C. E. Myocardial impairment. U. S. Veterans Bur. M. Bull, 1931, 7: 463-8.—Centurion, J. J. Miocardia: estado actual de la cuesti6n. Vida nueva, Habana, 1930, 26: 568-604.—Cotton, T. F. Some clinical aspects of myocardial disease. Clin. J, Lond, 1937, 66: 232-6.— Covey, G. W. Myocardial versus valvular defects. Nebraska M. J, 1932, 17: 448.—Gibson, A. G. Myocardium diseases. In Brit. Encycl M. Pract. (RoUeston, H.) Lond, 1937, 6: 277-87.—Gomez, F, & Gaggero, A. E. Un caso de miocardia. An. Fac. med, Montev, 1927, 12: 308-16, pl. Also Rev. med, Rosario, 1929, 4: 67-74.—Gonzalez Olaechea, M. Sobre un caso de miocardia. Crdn. med. mex, 1933, 32: 37-41.— Heimann, H. L. Affections of the myocardium. J. M. Ass. S. Africa, 1931, 5: 8-12.—Hyman, A. S, & Parsonnet, A. E. Myocardosis. J. Am. M. Ass, 1930, 94: 1645.—Laubry, C. Les myocardies. Bruxelles med, 1930-31, 11: 593-5. Also Dia med, B. Air, 1930-31, 3: 59-61. Also Echo med. nord, 1935, 3. ser, 3: 269-83. ------& Walser, J. Les myocardies. Rev. med. fr, 1926, 7: 73-5. Also Rev. brasil. med. farm, 1926, 2: 167-74.—Liggan, L. S. Myocardosis, a problem of preventive medicine. Virginia M. Month, 1935-36, 62: 208-15.—Lloyd, H. J. Chronic myocardial disease. Minne- sota M, 1936, 19: 203.—Magalhaes Gomes, E. de. Myo- cardia. Brasil med, 1932, 46: 131-5.—Mandelstamm, M. E. [Terminology of chronic diseases of the cardiac muscle] Sovet. vrach. gaz, 1933, 37: 79-85.—Martinez, G. Sobre algunos problemas de las lesiones de miocardio. Rev. As. med. argent, 1937, 51: 131-3.—Mascheroni, H, & Rossi, A. R. A prop6sito de las miocardias. Sem. med, B. Air, 1929, 36: 627-30 — Messinger, V. S. Myocardosis. Pennsylvania M. J, 1933, 37: 20-2.—Montes Pareja, J. Las miocardosis. Arch. urug. med, 1934, 4: 193-210.—Moon, R. O. Some observations on diseases of the myocardium. Brit. M. J, 1929, 2: 1-5.— Mut, A. Miocardia. Progr. din, Madr, 1927, 35: 910-2.— Nichols, W. C. Certain phases of myocardial diseases. J. Lancet, 1927, 47: 79-83.—Pern, S. Some common myo- cardial lesions. Med. J. & Rec, 1931, 133: 129-31.—Sanders, L. C. Chronic myocardial disease. Memphis M. J, 1932, 9: 166.—Smith, S. C. The clinical appraisal of heart muscle impairment; a plea for the older methods of heart study. Med. J. & Rec, 1933, 138: 289-92.—Sternberg, C. Ueber Erkrankungen des Myokard. Wien. klin. Wschr, 1928, 41: 1045-8.—Williams, W. R Some myocardial cases. Med. Clin. N. America, 1930, 14: 307-17.—Zelerin, V. F, Kogan, B B, & Kabakov, I. B. [Working abiUty in chronic affections of the cardiac muscle] Ter. arkh, 1933, 11: 697-713. ---- Disease: Diagnosis. Barth, F. *Das Zusammentreffen von radi- ologischen Merkmalen und elektrokardiographi- schen Veranderungen bei Myokardschadigung. lOp. 22V£cm. Basel, 1938. Also Schweiz. med. Wschr, 1938, 68: 1376-9. Arieff, M. Y. [Diagnosis of affection of the heart muscle] Vrach. gaz, 1930, 34: 143-50.—Bierring, W. L. Early recog- nition of myocardial disease. Ann. Int. M, 1934, 8: 497-503.— Bordet, F. A propos du diagnostic de myocardie. J. med. chir. Par, 1927, 98: 628-38—Chatel, A. de [Clinical diag- nosis of myocardial lesions] Budapesti orv. ujs, 1935, 33: 365-8.—Desmeules, R, & Marcoux, H. Cardiopathies et fausses tuberculoses. Bull. Soc. med. hop. Quebec, 1934, 227-32.—Dumas, A. Valeur des variations tensionneUes pour l'estimation des lesions du myocarde. Arch. mal. coeur, 1933, 26: 631-3.—Gressner, E. [Anoxemic tests in the examination of lesions of the cardiac muscle] Bratisl. lek. Usty, 1934, 14: 410-20.—Kauffmann. Zur Diagnose latenter Myokard- schadigung. Zbl. inn. Med, 1936, 57: 545.—Koumans, A. K. J. [Early diagnosis of affections of the myocardium] Geneesk. tschr. Ned. Indie, 1934, 74: 224-32. ------ [Early diagnosis of myocardial changes] Ibid, 297-306, pl—Leimdorfer, A. Zur Fruhdiagnose und Prognose der Myokarderkrankungen. Med. Klin, Berl, 1935, 31: 1536-8. ------ Zur Diagnostik der latenten Herzmuskelerkrankungen. Wien. Arch. inn. Med, 1935, 27: 215-40.—Levene, G., & Lowman, R. M. HEART MUSCLE 322 HEART MUSCLE Roentgen localization of myocardial damage resulting from coronary artery disease. Radiology, 1941, 36: 159-70.— Myocardosis—a syndrome: its recognition and therapeutic management. Nebraska M. J, 1934, 19: 151.—Parsonnet, A. E. Myocardosis; a plea for earlv recognition of coronarv artery disease. Ann. Int. M, 1937-38, 11: 2133-50.—Pezzi. C. L'examen radioscopique dans les affections du mvoearde. Arch. mal. coeur, 1933, 26: 629-31.—Stott, A. W, Bedford, E. [et al] Discussion on the recognition of mvocardial disease. Proc. R. Soc. M, Lond, 1935-36, 29: 141-50— Workmen's compensation acts; death caused by exertion and myocardial disease; compensable. J. Am. M. Ass, 1938. Ill: 1794. ---- Disease: Electrocardiography. Ftjenzalida Comas, O. *Reflejos cardio- vasculares en estados miocardicos inaparentes; estudio electrocardiografico [Chile] 77p. 26^cm. Santiago, 1940. Langenbach, E. *Untersuchungen iiber das Verhalten der Kammeranfangsschwankung im Elektrokardiogramm bei Myokardschadigung. 16p. 21cm. Bonn, 1937. Schmitz, G. *Ueber die Atemschwankungen des Elektrokardiogrammtyps bei Myokard- schaden. 16p. 8? Bonn, 1937. Ariev, M. I. [Significance of electrocardiography for diag- nosis of pathological conditions of the cardiac muscle in in- fections] Tr. Vtor. Leningr. med. inst, 1935, No. 6, 115-20 — Bau, C. A. Klinischer Beitrag zur Diagnose der Myokarder- krankungen auf (irund elektrokardiographischer Untersuchung. Zschr. klin. Med, 1034, 127: 172-81.—Biichner, F. Die Deutung des Llektrokanhogramms bei den Durchblutungs- storungen des Herzmuskels (vom Standpunkt des Pathologen) Klin. Wschr, 1938, 17: 1713; 1745. Clerc, A, & Quinquaud, A. Onde monophasee par traction sur l'apex du coeur exsangue et dnerve. C. rend. Soc. biol, 1938, 128: 256-9.-----■ Le complexe eiectrique du coeur aptes I'ablation de l'apex ven- triculaire. Ibid, 388-90. ------ Le complexe eiectrique du coeur aptes I'ablation d'un ventricule et de l'extremite apicale du ventricule restant. Ibid, 039-41. ------ Le complexe eiectrique du coeur pendant la traction sur l'extremite apicale d'un ventricule, la paroi de l'autre etant enlevde. Ibid, 1939, 130: 451-3. ------ Le complexe eiectrique du coeur etire par une traction sur ses bords. Ibid, 131: 1187-90.— Condorelli, L. Ueber die Bedeutung der respiratorischen Formveranderungen des Ekg's zum Nachweis einer Myo- kardschiidigung. Verh. Deut. Ges. Kreislaufforsch, 1935, 8: 207-12 [Discussion] 227.—Cowan, J. The electrocardio- graphic evidence of myocardial disease. Tr. R. Med. Chir. Soc. Glasgow, 1926, 20: 41-54, 2 pl. Also Glasgow M. J, 1926, 105: 4-16, 2 pl—Crawford, J. H, Roberts, G. H. [et al] Localization of experimental ventricular myocardial lesions by the electrocardiogram. Am. Heart J, 1932, 7: 627-40.— Dressier, W. Die Bedeutung der Elektrokardiographie fiir die Diagnostik der Herzmuskelerkrankungen. Wien. klin. Wschr, 1937, 50: 1069.—Duomarco, J. Diagnostic de localisa- tion d'une lesion tecente du myocarde au moyen de l'eiectro- cardiogramme. C. rend. Soc. biol, 1933, 114: 779-83.— Electrocardiograma (El) en el diagnostico diferencial de las enfermedades miocardicas y de las arritmias. Dfa med, B. Air, 1941, 13: 455.—Eyster, J. A. E, & Goldberg, H. The relation of injury potentials in heart muscle to other electrical and to mechanical events. Am. J. Physiol, 1941, 133: 272.— Eyster, J. A. E, Meek, W. J. [et al] Potential changes in an injured region of cardiac muscle. Ibid, 1938, 124: 717-28.— Fernos Isern, A. Interpretaciones electrocardiograficas de ciertas condiciones patologicas del miocardio. Bol As. med. Puerto Rico, 1935, 27: 113-22—Flaum, E. Ueber Verande- rungen des menschlichen Elektrokardiogramms bei circum- scripten Herzmuskellasionen. Kim. Wschr, 1933, 12: 498.— Frey, W. El electrocardiograma en lesiones del miocardio (salvo arritmias) Rev. med. Hamburgo, 1926, 7: 160-5.— Gerbasi, M. Le correnti d'azione del cuore in alcune malattie infettive dei bambini (difterite, scarlattina, tifo, amebiasi) Ann. clin. med. Pal, 1929, 19: 263-313.—Henning, F. Myo- cardschaden im Kymogramm. Med. Welt, 1937, 11: 1068- 72.—Hinrichs, A. Die Bedeutung kurzfristiger und feinster Formanderungen der elektrokardiographischen Kurve zur Erkennung von frischen Herzmuskelschaden. Zschr Kreis- laufforsch, 1937, 29: 705-10.—Hubbs, R. S. Chronic myo- cardial disease: a study of the relationship between physical and electrocardiographic findings in 70 cases of myocardial disease. Rocky Mountain M. J, 1938, 35: 474-7.—Ingrassia, G. L'elettrocardiogramma e la sua importanza pratica nella diagnostica delle malattie del miocardio. Cult. med. mod Pal, 1939, 18: 181-9.—Katz, L. N, Sugarman, H. [et alj Observations on the potentials established by injury to the heart. Am. J. Physiol, 1940, 129: 394.—Kisch, F. Beitrag zur Bedeutung thorakaler Ableitung fiir die elektrokardio- graphische Ermittlung von Myokarclschaden. Klin. Wschr, 1937, 16: 83.—Lian, C. Importance de l'atypie ventriculaire eiectrocardiographique dans le diagnostic, le pronostic et le traitement des syndromes myocardiques sans troubles du rythme. Presse med, 1930, 38: 481-5. ------& Blondel, A. Importancia de la electrocardiografla en el diagnostico de'la- afecciones del miocardio. Sem. med, B. Air, 1930, 37: 826-8.— I.ian. C, & Merklen. F. P. Alterations experimentales dee portions moyenne et terminate du complexe ventriculaire eiectrocardiographique (compression de 1'artdre pulmonaire^ C. rend. Soc. biol, 1931, 107: 699.—Malamani, V, & Kienle. F. Sulla diagnosi elettrocardiografica delle lesioni miocnnliclic. Gazz. osp, 1939, 60: 731-8.—Master. A. W, & Pardee, H. E. B. The effect of heart muscle disease on the electro- cardiogram. Arch. Int. M, 1926, 37: 42-65. Also repr.— Meek, W. J, Eyster, J. A. E, & Goldberg, H. Certain charac- teristics of injury potential in cardiac muscle. Am. J. Physiol 1939, 126: 583-.—Meyer, W. C. Ueber die Beurteilung der Veranderungen im Elektrokardiogramm, die auf eine Erkran- kung des Myokards hinweben. Zschr. klin. Med, 1937-38, 133: 105-31.—Milew, A, & Weber, A. Klinische und experi- mentelle Studien iiber das Elektrokardiogramm; das Ver- halten des Kammer-Ekg. bei Myokardschadigung im Verlauf von Jahren. Ibid, 1935-36, 129: 52-61.—Munteanu, V. [Important modifications in electrocardiography for the diagnosis of affections of the myocardium] Rev. san. mil, Bucur, 1934, 33: 104-11.—Nieuwenhuizen, C. L. C. van. Die thorakale Ableitung im Dienste der Diagnostik von Myo- kardschfidigungen. Wien. Arch. inn. Med, 1936, 29: 25-36.— Parade, G. W, & Stepp, W. Ueber experimentell erzeugte Myokardschadigungen durch Jodipininjektion in die Herz- kammerwandung des Hundes und die dabei auftretenden Veranderungen im Elektrokardiogramm. Zschr. klin. Med 1930, 113: 195-211. ------ Ueber die Bewertung der Final- schwankung des Elektrokardiogramms fiir die Diagnose von Myokardschadigungen. Klin. Wschr, 1931, 10: 684-6.— Pardee, H. E. B, & Price, L. Relation of myocardial disease to abnormalities of the ventricular complex of the electro- cardiogram. Tr. Ass. Am. Physicians, 1937, 52: 330—11. Also Am. Heart J, 1938, 15: 28-44.—Reid, L. C, & Brace, D. E. Irritation of the upper respiratory tract and esophagus and its reflex effect upon the heart as shown by the electro- cardiograph. Am. J. Physiol, 1939, 126: 606.—Rothschuh, K. E. Ueber die Entstehung von Verletzungsstromen und monophasischer Deformierung der Herzaktionsstrome durch korpereigene Substanzen. Zschr. ges. exp. Med, 1939, 106: 543-54.—Routier, D, & Lequime, J. Importance semiologique de reiectrorardiogramme au cours des atteintes myocardo- coronarienues. Presse rndd, 1934, 42: 304-7.—Sakurasawa, F, n (lie genesis of the electrical currents established by injury to the heart. Am. J. Physiol, 1940, 130: 130-43.— Uhlenbruck, P. Der Nachweis der Herzmuskelschadigung im Elektrokardiogramm. Vertrauensarzt, 1935, 3: 121-8.— Van Bogaert, A, & van Bogaert, L. Aspect de 1 onde et de l'espace S-T de l'eiectrocaidiogramme dans la myopathie. Bull. Soc. med. hop. Paris, 1934, 3. ser, 50: 1065-8.—Weber, A. Ueber die Bedeutung des Elektrokardiogramms fiir den Nachweis von Herzmuskelschadigung. Zbl. inn. Med, 1935, 56: 161-73. Also Verh. Deut. Ges. Kreislaufforsch, 1939, 12: 43-76 [Discussion] 77-106.—Weicker, B. Infektios-toxische Myokardschadigung im Elektrokardiogramm. Klin. Wschr., 1937, 16: 516-9.—Zarday, I. [Electrocardiogram of myo- cardial affection] Orv. hetil, 1936, 80: meU, 172.—Zelenin, V. F. [Electrocardiographic analysis of myocardial reactions] In Recueil Strajeako (Bogomoletz, A.) Kiev, 1935, 873 6. ---- Disease: Etiology. See also names of primary disease as Coronary vessels, Disease; Deficiency disease; Diphtheria; Syphilis; Thyrotoxicosis, &c. Rook, G. D. *Etude d'un cas de syndrome hepato-endocrinomyocardique. 52p. 2454cm. Par., 1938. Albert, Z. [Changes in the myocardium in acute and chronic diseases in children^ Nowiny lek, 1938, 50: 565; 619.—Beck, C. S, & Bright, E. F. Changes in the heart and pericardium brought about by compression of the legs and abdomen. J. I horac Surg, 1933, 2: 616-28.—Bickel, G. Infections focalea ioIv01' fonctionnels myocardiques. Rev. med. Suisse rom, 1941, 61: 578.—Bonsdorff, B. von. Myocardial disease of obscure origin. Acta med. scand, 1939, 100: 403-35.—Cerioli, E. Alterazioni mioeardiche ed endocardiche da anafilassi acuta e cronica. Profilassi, 1933, 6: 221-3—DorendorL Zur Klinik der Herzmuskelerkrankungen bei akuten Iiifektionskrankheiten. i 'le? , verstorb. GeneraLstabsarzt Armee Leuthold, 1906, 1: 467-95.— Fahr, G. The etiology of the chronic heart muscle diseases of frequent occurrence in general practice. Minnesota M. 1926, 9: 5-8.—Ferrannini, A. La disfunzione del miocardio nelle anomalie della tono-elasticiU vasale. Cuore & circol, HEART MUSCLE 323 HEART MUSCLE 1936, 20: 255-62.—Franz, G. Eine seltene Form von toxischer Myokardschadigung. Virchows Arch, 1936-37, 298: 743-52.— Gounelle, H. Les myocardies de carence Bi, alcoolique, beri- berique, etc. Bull. Soc. med. hop. Paris, 1939, 3. ser, 55: 1048- 50.—Hara, K, Ohtomo, F. [et al] Klinische und experimen- telle Forschungs-Ergebnisse iiber die Kuoshan-Krankheit, eine in der Mandschurei auftretende Herzmuskel-Erkrankung. Jap. J. M. Sc, 1938-39, 5: Proc. Int. Med, 251.—Kamberg, J. A. M. Ueber Herzmuskelveranderungen bei Koronarin- suffiz'ienz. Arch. Kreislaufforsch, 1938, 3: 34f>-412.—Langeron, L La myocardie alcoolique; le facteur nevrite dans les myo- cardies. J. med. chir. Par, 1936, 107: 353-73. ------ Avitaminose Bi et insuffisance cardiaque; le cas de la myo- cardie alcoolique assimilable k un beriberi nostras. Presse med, 1939, 47: 1189-91.—Liebmann, E. Untersuchungen iiber die Herzmuskulatur bei Infektionskrankheiten. Deut. Arch. klin. Med, 1915, 118: 190-213. —;--- Ueber Schadi- gung der Herzmuskulatur durch infektiose Erkrankungen. Korbl. schweiz. Aerzte, 1917, 47: 280.—Molinari, E. Le alterazioni del miocardio nelle malattie infettive dell'mfanzia. Riv. clin. pediat, 1929, 27: 442-66, 2 pl—Nikolaev, N. M., Priselkov, M. M, & Lodyzhenskaia, S. I. [Morphological and functional changes of the myocardium in infections and intoxi- cations] J. rann. detsk. vozr, 1933, 13: 303-10.—NobScourt. Syndrome myocardique subaigu de cause indeterminee et nephrite intercurrente chez une fille de 10 ans. Rev. gen. clin. ther, 1936, 50: 177; 195.—Obscure myocardial disease. Brit. M. J, 1935, 1: 382.—Primak, F. J. [Dystrophy of the myo- cardium and the lymphatic system in allergy] J. med, Kiev, 1939-40, 10: 429-35, 6 pl—Rapoport, J. L. Dystrophic allergique du myocarde (myocardiopathia allergica) Acta med. URSS, 1938, 1: 315-29, 2 pl—Sanchez Ruiz, M. Aportaci6n al estudio de las miocardosis dLstroficas hipotiroideas. Actual. med, Granada, 1941, 17: 69-73.—Sassone, N. Disendocrinia e miocardia emotive in gravidanza. Terapia, Milano, 1932, 22: 97-107.—Thomas, R. M., Mylon, E, & Winternitz, M. C. Myocardial lesions resulting from dietary deficiency. Yale J. Biol, 1939-40, 12: 345-60, 4 pl Also Am. J. Path, 1940, 16: 667.—Von der Weth, G. Myokarderkrankung mit Herz- rhvthmusstorung bei einem jugendlichen Tuberkulosen. Zschr. klin. Med, 1932, 122: 118-33.—Weicker, B. Bei- chronisch entziindlichen Tonsillenerkrankungen auftretende Herzveranderungen. Zbl. inn. Med, 1939, 60: 497-9.------ & Retzlaff, L. Myokarderkrankungen infolge Tonsilleninfek- tion. Deut. Arch. klin. Med, 1939, 184: 316-38.—Wein- schenk, K. Herzmuskelveranderungen bei pathologischer Belastung des rechten Ventrikels. Beitr. path. Anat, 1939, 102: 477-84.—Zibordi, F. Miocardio e sindromi miocardiche in alcune malattie acute nell'infanzia. CUn. pediat. Mod, 1931, 13: 433-45. ---- Disease, experimental. Frey & Tiemann. Ueber Versuche mit experimenteller Myokardschadigung. Verh. Deut. Ges. inn. Med, 1926, 28. Kongr, 321.—Manning, G. W., Hall, G. E, & Banting, F. G. Vagus stimulation and the production of myocardial damage. Canad. M. Ass. J, 1937, 37: 314-8.—Menne, F. R, Jones, O. N, & Jones, N. W. Changes in the myocardium of rabbits from augmenting the heart rate mechanically and from induced hyperthyroidism. Arch. Path, Chic, 1934, 17: 333-55 — Rente, H. Elektrophysiologische und histologisohe Unter- suchungen iiber experimentell gesetzte Herzmuskelschaden. Zschr. ges. exp. Med, 1936-37, 100: 640-53.—Robb, J. S., & Robb, R. C. Experimental cardiac muscle lesions in the monkey. Am. J. Physiol. 1935, 113: 111—Rossler, R. Ueber experimentelle Herzschadigung durch Koronargefass- verengerung und ihre Beeinflussung durch Pharmaka. Arch. exp. Path, Lpz, 1930, 153: 1-35. ---- Disease: Manifestation. See also Extrasystole; Heart arrhythmia; Heart-block, &c. Borissova, E. [Local affection of the myocardium as source of extra excitement] Med. biol. J, Leningr, 1926, 2: No. 6, 11-6.—Casauton, A, & Cossoy, S. Sindrome miocardico agudo. Arch, argent, pediat, 1933, 4: 753-9.—Cotton, T. F. Des aspects cliniques des affections du myocarde. Arch. mal. cceur, 1933, 26: 628.—Donini, G. Atipie sindromiche da lesioni del miocardio. Gazz. osp, 1940, 61: 263-6.—Elizalde, P., & Elizalde, F. Sindrome miocardico a repetici6n. Arch. argent, pediat, 1934, 5: 259-66.—Glassner, R. [CUnical importance of Tschermak and Aschner signs in affections of myocardium] Polska gaz. lek, 1926, 5: 823-5.—Hyman, A. S, & Parsonnet, A. E. Myocardosis; the fading heart of middle life; early cUnical manifestations. N. England J. M, 1931, 204: 648-52.—Kirch, A. Zur Symptomatologie der Herz- muskelerkrankungen. Wien. kUn. Wschr, 1937, 50: 935-7.— Kossmann, C. E. Potential variations of extremities and of precordium in myocardial diseases. Proc. Soc. Exp. Biol, N. Y, 1935-36, 33: 146-8.—Libensky. La cUnique des affections du myocarde. Arch. mal. coeur, 1933, 26: 619-21.— Martini, T., & Joselevich, M. Miocardia y sindrome de Bernneim (comentarios que sugieren dos observaciones com- pletas) Sem. med, B. Air, 1928, 35: pt 2, 974-87.— Riesman, D. Myocardial disease and its gastric masquerades. J. Am. M. Ass, 1928, 91:1521-3.—Routier, D, Thomas, M., & Vadon, H. Symptdmes et formes cUniques des myocardies. J. med. fr, 1926, 15: 145-54.—Vallino, M. T., & Bettinotti, S. I. Sindrome miocardico agudo. Arch, argent, pediat, 1933, 4: 789-95.—Zelenin, V. P. Processus pathophysiologiques du myocarde et leurs symptomes cUniques. Acta med. URSS. ---- Disease: Military aspect. Labougle. Myocardies et insuffisance primitive (asthenie) du cceur chez le soldat. Bull. Soc. mid. mil. fr, 1926, 20: 276- 81.—Neidhardt, K., & Thierschmann, W. Ueber Myokard- schadigungen wahrend des Heeresdienstes. Zschr. klin. Med, 1937-38, 133: 449-57. ---- Disease: Pathology. Liebner, H. *Untersuchungen iiber plotzliche Todesfalle bei Schweinen und ihre Beziehungen zu Veranderungen des Herzmuskels. 22p. 8? Borna-Lpz., 1932. Brown, G. E, jr, & Hunt, H. F. A pathological classification of diseases of the myocardium. Am. J. Clin. Path, 1940, 10: 540-7.—Ceelen, W. Ueber den jetzigen Stand der Lehre von den Myokarderkrankungen. Deut. med. Wschr, 1929, 55: 569-72.—Chaika, E. I. [Morphological changes in the myo- cardium in chronic affections of the heart] J. med, Kiev, 1938, 8: 751-61— Durlacher, S. H, & Winternitz, M. C. Studies on the relation of the kidney to cardiovascular disease: lesions of the myocardium. Yale J. Biol, 1941-42, 14: 269-78, 2 pl— Hechtman, A. N, & Berkman, R. S. [Nomenclature and classification of diseases of the cardiac muscle] Vrach. delo, 1935, 18: 491-6.—Hochhaus & Dreesen. Vorkommen und Bedeutung von anatomischen Veranderungen des Herzmuskels bei der Herzschwache. In Festschr. Feier lOjahr. Besteh. Akad. prakt. Med. Coin, Bonn, 1915, 384-419.—Leman, N. M. [Clinical classification of diseases of the myocardium] Sovet. vrach. gaz, 1933, 37: 681-4.—Lowe, T. E. A note on the musculature of the human heart as illustrated by pathological processes. Med. J. Australia, 1940, 1: 826-8.—Martinez, G. N. Classification des lesions du muscle cardiaque. Bull. Acad. med. Roumanie, 1936, 1: pt 2, 804-11.—Martini, T, Joselevich, M, & Cordes, G. M. Miocardias: referenda de 3 observaciones clinicas; una de ellas con estudio amitomopatol6gico. Sem. med, B. Air, 1928, 35: 2-19.—Nieuwenhuijse, P. Ueber eine ge- wisse Selbstandigkeit der Herzmuskelsegmente in pathologi- schen Verhaltnissen. Verh. Deut. path. Ges, 1928, 23: 491- 5.—Okita, K. Beitrag zur Kenntnis der Pathologie der Herz- muskelmitochondrien. Fukuoka acta med, 1937, 30: 129-32. Also Jap. J. M. Sc, 1938-39, 5: Proc. Int. Med, 74-6.— Schlomka, G, & Konigs, G. Ueber das Verhalten der relativen Systolendauer bei Herzmuskelkranken. Zschr. Kreislaufforsch, 1938, 30: 825-34.—Scott, L. C. Principal inorganic constitu- ents of diseased cardiac muscle. Proc. Soc. Exp. Biol, N. Y, 1929-30, 27: 79.—Sikl. Anatomie pathologique des affections du myocarde. Arch. mal. cceur, 1933, 26: 633-5.—Wencke- bach, K. F. Quellung der Herzmuskelfasern als Ursache schwerster Herzschwache. Verh. Deut. Ges. inn. Med, 1929, 41. Kongr, 349.—Willius, F. A. The progression of myocardial disease as recorded by serial electrocardiograms. Med. CUn. N. America, 1933, 16: 1493-502. ---- Disease: Treatment. Agduhr, E. Die Bedeutung der Diat fur Regenerationen von Herzmuskelschaden. Upsala lak. foren forh, 1934, 39: 65-81, 7 pl.—Bierring, W. L. Myocardosis, a syndrome; its recogni- tion and therapeutic management. J. Am. M. Ass, 1933, 101: 663-6.—Castelle-Rothe, A. Folinerin und die Behandlung der Herzmuskelerkrankungen. Ther. Gegenwart, 1939, 80: 355- 9.—Gotsch, K. Therapie der Myokardschaden. Med. KUn, Berl, 1936, 32: 275-8.—Hersonskaka, R. Kurzwellentherapie bei Myokarderkrankungen. Ref. Internat. Kongr. KurzweUen, 1937, 1. Kongr, 249.—Jagifi, N. Zur Klinik und Therapie der Myokarderkrankungen. Wien. med. Wschr, 1934, 84: 861. ------ & Zimmermann, O. Zur Klinik und Therapie der Myokarderkrankungen. Wien. klin. Wschr, 1934, 47: 1217; 1255.—Kielhorn, E. Die Behandlung postinfektioser Myo- kardschaden im Kindesalter; elektrokardiographische Be- obachtungen. Med. Welt, 1935, 9: 1699-702.—Morawitz, P. Medikamentose Therapie der nichtdekompensierten Herz- muskelerkrankungen. Deut. med. Wschr, 1935, 61: 1; 45.— Sciacca, F. II trattamento chirurgico di rivascolarizzazione del miocardio negli stati d'insufficiente irrorazione cardiaca, con speciale reguardo all'angina di petto. CUn. chir, Milano, 1939, 42: 815; 887; 995. ---- Dromotropism. See Heart conduction. ---- Echinococcosis. Latki, J. *Ueber einen Fall von primarem Herzechinokokkus mit Cestodenembolie. 37p. 8? Berl., 1926. Agote, L, Goyena, J. R, & Bianchi, A. E. Hidatidosis del corazon. Rev. Soc. med. int., B. Air, 1927, 3: 469-514. Also Sem. med, B. Air., 1927, 34: pt 2, 1717-34.—Bacaloglu, C. HEART MUSCLE 324 HEART MUSCLE Balan. N. [et al] Le kvste hydatique du cceur. Ann. med. Par, 1929, 36: 242-68.—Ballotta, F. Cisti d'echinococco del cuore. Arch. ital. anat. pat, 1936, 7: 453-41.—Benhamou, E, Montpellier, R, & Solal, G. C. Kyste hydatique du coeur. Arch. mal. coeur, 193S. 31: 17-24.—Blondeau, A, Laupretre & Miramond de Laroquette. Kyste hydatique du cceur; parti- cularite.s de l'image radiologique. Bull. Soc. eiectroradiol med. France, 1938, 26: 194-7.—Dobrotin, A. N. [Three cases of echinococcus of the heart] Russ. klin, 1926, 5: 272-81. Also Virchows Arch, 1926. 261: 575-85.—Dungal. N. Echinokokkus des Herzens. Acta path, microb. scand, 1938, 15: 90-100.— Gonzalez Bosch, R, & Mosto, D. Hidatidosis cardiaca; hidatidosis cardfaca en un paciente con cuadro clinico-electro- cardiognifico de infarto de miocardio. Prensa med. argent, 1937. 24: 308-18- Hatzeganu, I, Vasiliu. T., & Moga, A. Le kyste hydatiiiue du coeur simulant un anevrisme. Arch. mal. cceur, 1936, 29: 72-S.—Heimann, H. L. llvdatid cvst in the heart. Brit. M. J.. 1028, 1 : 801.— Ischanow, C. S. Leber den Echinococcus des Herzens. Frankf. Z.-chr. Path, 1936, 50: 123-5.—Khalil Bey, M. llvdatid cyst of the heart as a cause of sudden death. J. En\ pt. M. Ass, l'.)34, 17: 796-8 — Lutembacher, R. Kyste hydatique en involution et syndrome ventriculaire droit. Ann. med. Par, 1938, 44: 455-8.— Morquio, I, Kyste hydatique primitif du myocarde ouvert dans le ventricule gauche; hydatose metastatique, avec 9 kvstes dans le eerveau et 2 kvstes dans la rate. Arch. nted. enf.. 1034. 37: 90-6—Niseggi. ('. H, & Quiros, J. B. de. Sobre un caso de hidatidosis eardiaca. Sem. med, B. Air, 1939, 46: 693-705—Pozharsky, F. I. [Case of echinococcus of the heart] Sovet. khir., 1034. 7: 144-7.—Pullar, T. H, & North, J. . H. Ruptmed hydatid cvst of the heart. Austral. N. Zealand J. Sur-., 193S-39, 8: 309-403.—Saglam, T. Ein Fall von Herzecliinokokkus. Wien. Arch. inn. Med, 1935, 27: 347-52. —---- Ln cas de kyste hydatique du cceur; presentation de piece anatonuque. C. rend. Congr. internat. path, comp, 1036. 3. Congr, 147.—Scaglia, G. Sull'echinocoecosi primitiva del cuore. Atti Soc. sc. med. natur. Cagliaii, 1030, 5 n. ser., 32: 87-96. Also Gazz. med. lombarda, 1030, 89: 275-81.--Vara L6pez, R. Sobre un nuevo caso de quistes hidatidicos multiples de corazon. Pmgr. din, .Madr, 1031.39:541. Also Zbl. Chir, 1931, 58: 238-1-7. Vydrin. A. M. Ein Fall von Herzechino- coccus. Wien. klin. Wsehr, 1937, 50: 1135-7. Also Vrach. delo, 1938, 20: 130-42. ---- Elasticity. See also subheading Tonus. Aragona, P. II tessuto elastico del miocardio ventricolare. Pathologicr*. Genova, 1939, 31: 202-7.—Eismayer, G, & Quincke, 11. Zum Tonusproblem des Herzmuskels; die Be- einflussinin der Ruheelastizitiit (lurch (iifte. Arch. exp. Path Lpz, 192*. 137: 362-70.—Kabat, H, /2cm. Halle, 1937. Grosse, F. *Elektrokardiographische Be- funde bei Herzinfarkt. p.245-320. 24cm. Berl, 1938. Also Arch. Kreislaufforsch., 1938, 3: Hommel, E. *Das Elektrokardiogramm bei Herzinfarkt [Munchen] 19p. 21cm. Gunz- burg, 1938. Jervell, A. Elektrokardiographische Be- funde bei Herzinfarkt. 267p. 8? Oslo, 1935. Pelaez y del Casal, M. *De l'utilite- des derivations precordials pour le diagnostic de l'infarctus du myocarde. 79p. 24^cm. Par., 1938. Wiedemann, R. [F. A.] *Ueber das Elektro- kardiogramm bei Myokardinfarkt, Angina pec- toris und Aortensklerose [Breslau] 24p. 8°. Zeulenroda, 1933. Agostoni, G. Sindrome anginosa simulante un infarto mio- cardico; importanza dell'eliettro-cardiogramma ad un preciso diagnostico. Boll. spec. med. chir, 1929, 3: 236-40.—Aixala, K. El electrocardiograma en un caso de infarto cardiaco. Vida nueva, Habana, 1931, 28: 715-9.—Annis, J. W. Myo- cardial infarction; electrocardiographic changes and necropsy findings. J. Florida M. Ass, 1939-40, 26: 131-7.—Apical (The) lead in the diagnosis of cardiac infarction. Lancet, Lond, 1938, 1: 1343.—Barnes, A. R. Q and T types of electro- cardiograms: their comparative and complementary value in indicating occurrence of acute myocardial infarction. Am. Heart J, 1934, 9: 722-7. Also Arch. lat. amer. card, Mex, 1933-34, 4: 37-45. ------ Electrocardiogram in myocardial infarction; review of 107 cUnical cases and 108 cases proved at necropsy Arch. Int. M 1935, 55: 457-83. ------& Whitten, A™ tr *d¥ °ih„e,F interval in myocardial infarction. Am Heart J, 1929-30, 5: 142-71.-Battro, A. Evoluci6n electrocardiografica del infarto miocardico. Dia med B Air 1938, 10: 1301 —Broustet, P. Infacrtus du myocarde a instal- lation lente; etude eiectrocardiographique avant et apres la constitution de la lesion. Arch. mal. cceur, 1937 30-881-5__ Burger, R, & Wuhrmann, F. Ueber elektrokardiographische Analyse mittels Vektordiagramm und elektrischem Feld- Uemonstration an einem Vorderwand-Spitzen-Infarkt mit W- lorm des Initialkomplexes in den Ableitungen I and II und kleinen Ausschlagen in alien Extremitaten-Ableituno-en Schweiz. med. Wschr, 1941, 71: 65-72.—Castillo, P. A. Infarto cardiaco. Vida nueva, Habana, 1931, 27: 543; 28: 1__ Clerc, A, & Levy, R. Modifications des complexes eiectriques ventriculaires observees dans le cas d'infarctus myocardique J. med. fr 1930, 19: 57-64.—Coelho, E., & Rocheta, J. Les troubles electrocardiographiques dans l'infarctus myocardique experimental apres section des nerfs vagosympathiques cervi- caux. C. rend. Soc. biol, 1929, 102: 205.—Contratto, A. W Robinson R. W, & Levine, S. A. The precordial lead; the hndings for patients with myocardial infarction. Arch Int M, 1939, 63: 732-51.—Cutts, F. B., Clagett, A. H, jr, & Fulton, F. T. Smallness or absence of initial positive deflections in the precordial electrocardiogram and cardiac infarction; a study of patients who came to autopsy. Ibid, 1941, 67: 509- 3P-—Davis, N. S, III. Three cases of extensive cardiac infarc- tion with electrocardiographic stuoies and necropsy findings Med. Clin. N. America, 1930-31, 14: 1097-111.—Donzelot, E, & Boucomont, R. El diagn6stico electrocardiografico del infarto del miocardio. Dia med, B. Air, 1929-30, 2: 800 Also Bull, med. Par, 1930, 44:125-7.—Enesco, J, & Vacareano! N. Infarctus du myocarde; persistance d'une dutee exception- nelle de la grande onde monophasique et du T en dome. Arch mal. cceur, 1937, 30: 318-23.—Espejo Sola, J. Evoluci6n de la curva electrocardiogrdfica en un caso de infarto lento del mio- cardio. Sem. med, B. Air, 1936, 43: pt 2, 1073-7.—Faulkner, J. M. The electrocardiographic diagnosis of acute cardiac infarction with special reference to the value of precordial leads N. England J. M, 1935, 213: 1215-9.—Francaviglia, A. Ricerche sperimentali sulla genesi delle manifestazioni elettro- cardiografiche consecutive ad infarto miocardico. Cuore & circol, 1933, 17: 589-96.— Freundlich. J. Die klinische Bedeutung der Elektrokardiographie bei Herzinfarkt. Deut. Arch. klin. Med, 1936-37, 179: 622-37.------Zur diagno- stischen Bedeutung der Brustwandableitungen. Acta med. scand, 1939, 98: 83-94.—Geraudel, E. Les signes electro- cardiographiques de l'infarctus du myocarde. Bull med. Par, 1934, 48: 412-4.—Gilchrist, A. R, & Ritchie, W. T. The ventricular complexes in myocardial infarction and fibrosis. Q. J. Med, Oxf, 1929-30, 23: 273-92.—Giraud, G, Mas, P. [et al] Evolution eiectrocardiographique d'un infarctus du myocarde. Arch. Soc. sc. med. biol. Montpellier, 1939, 20: 421-7.—Gold, H, Modell, W., & Travell, J. The influence of the size of cardiac infarcts upon the electrocardiogram. Am. Heart J, 1938, 15: 77-82.—Grosse, F. Elektrokardiographische Befunde bei Herzinfarkt unter besonderer Berucksichtigung von Brustwandableitungen. Arch. Kreislaufforsch, 1938, 3: 245-320.—Grotel, D. M. [Electrocardiographic examination in obstruction of the coronary vessels of the heart and in infarction of the myocardium] Ter. arkh, 1932, 10: 140-3.— Haase, B. Ueber den Wert der Brustwandableitung fiir die elektrokardiographische Diagnostik des Herzinfarktes. Zschr. klin. Med, 1939-40, 137: 203-42.—Hahn, L. Interferenz- Erscheinungen am Kammerelektrokardiogramm bej wieder- holtem Myokardinfarkt. Zschr. Kreislaufforsch, 1933, 25: 369-75.—Hamilton, J. G. M, & Nyboer, J. The ventricular deflections in myocardial infarction; an electrocardiographic study using esophageal and precordial leads. Am. Heart J, 1938, 15: 414-24.—Helman, I, & Levina, S. [Electrocardio- graphic changes in infarction of the myocardium] Sovet. klin, 1934, 20: 243-50.—Herles, F. [Value of successive changes of the electrocardiogram after infarction of the myocardium] Cas. lek. Cesk, 1931, 70: 855-60.—Hill, I. G. W, Johnston, F. D, & Wilson, F. N. The form of the electrocardiogram in experimental myocardial infarction; the later effects produced by ligation of the right coronary artery. Am. Heart J, 1938, 16: 309-20.—Israel, J. E. La derivaci6n medio axilar; su importancia en el diagn6stico del infarto de miocardio. Rev. argent, card, 1937-38, 4: 254-63. ------ & Ferretti, J. Sobre la aparicion tardfa de las modificaciones electrocardio- grdficas en el infarto del miocardio. Prensa med. argent, 1937, 24: 1883-7.—Jagic, N. von, & Zimmermann-Meinzingen. Zur Wertung des Elektrokardiogramms bei der Differential-diagnose des akuten Myokardinfarktes. Wien. Arch. inn. Med, 1937, 30: 187-96.—Johnston, F. D., Hill, 1. G. W., & Wilson, F. N. The form of the electrocardiogram in experimental myocardial infarction; the early effects produced by ligation of the anterior descending branch of the left coronary artery. Am. Heart J, 1934-35, lu: 889-902.—Kartagener, M. Die M- und W-formige Aufsplitterung der Anfangsschwankung im Elektrokardio- gramm des Myokardinfarktes. Schweiz. med. Wschr, 1941, 71: 265-8.—Kavanaugh, C. N. The role of the electrocardio- gram in the diagnosis, prognosis and management of cardiac infarction. Kentucky M. J, 1938, 36: 28-30.—Kossmann, C. E, & de la Chapelle, C. E. The precordial electrocardio- gram in myocardial infarction; observations on cases in which the lesions were diffuse. Am. Heart J, 1939, 18: 352-62. Observations on cases of infarction of the posterior wall of the left ventricle. Ibid, 344-51.—Langendorf, R. The HEART MUSCLE 332 HEART MUSCLE effect of diffuse pericarditis on the electrocardiographic pattern of recent myocardial infarction. Ibid, 1941, 22: 86-104. ------& Pick, A. Zur Diagnose des Myokardinfa'rktes mit Hilfe von Brustwandableitungen. Acta med. scand, 1938, 96: 80-100.—Lucherini, T., & Sibilia, D. Sul valore delle curve elettriche da infarto del miocardio senza corrispondente sin- drome clinica dolorosa. Athena, Roma, 1939, 8: 481-8.— Lukomsky, P. E. [Changes in the electrocardiogram in thoracic deviations in infarct of the heart] Ter. arkh, 1938, 16: Nos. 1-2, 39-40.—Lyons, R. E, jr. Coronary occlusion with myo- cardial infarction; 3 cases with serial electrocardiograms. J. Indiana M. Ass, 1940, 33: 134-6.—Morelli, A. C. Diagn6stico electrocardiogrdfico del infarto del miocardio. Arch. urug. med, 1933, 2: 3-46.—Mortensen, V. [Significance of prae- cordial deviations in electrocardiography, especially in heart infarct] Hospitalstidende, 1936, 79: 1233-52. ------ Signifi- cance of precordial leads in electrocardiography, especially in cardiac infarction. Acta med. scand, 1937, 92: 603-29. ------ [Analvsis of the QRS-complex in the precordial leads in infarct of the anterior wall] Nord. med, 1939, 3: 2749-56. Also Am. J. M. Sc, 1941, 201: 349-57.—Nechat Omer. Sur les modifications evolutives du complexus ventriculaire eiectri- que dans un cas d'infarctus myocardique. Presse med, 1930, 38: 332.—Nielsen, H. [Heart infarct, demonstrated in the 4th lead] Ugeskr. laeger, 1937, 99: 809-12.—Nordenfelt, O. [Electrocardiogram deviation in the 4th lead and cardiac infarction] Hygiea, Stockh, 1935, 97: 933-46.—Nyboer, J. The normal and abnormal esophageal electrocardiogram, with particular reference to myocardial infarction. Am. Heert J, 1941, 22: 469-93.—Ortega, L., jr, & Aixala, R. Discordancia electro-anat6mica en un caso de infarto cardfaco. Rev. med. cubana, 1934, 45: 552-8.—Padilla, T, & Cossio, P. EI electro- cardiograma ventricular en el infarto miocdrdico. Sem. med, B. Air, 1929, 36: pt 2, 813-23. Also Rev. sudamer. med. Par, 1931, 2: 129-40.—Pezzi, C. Diagnosi retrospettiva d'infarto miocardico mediante l'elettrocardiogramma. Atti Soc. lombard. sc. med, 1928, 17: 207-12.—Puddu, V. Osservazioni cliniche ed elettrocardiografiche su 30 casi di infarto del mio- cardio. Boll. Accad. med. Roma, 1938, 64: 118. Also Minerva med. Tor, 1938, 29: pt 2, 9-15.—Ramos, J, & Marino Bechelli, I, Alterac5es eletrocardiogriificas no enfarte do miociirdio. Ann. paul med. cir, 1935, 30: 593-624.—Schenk, P. Die Krkciiiiunir. von Herzmuskelschadigungen, insbesondere von lnf;n kt in durch Elektrokardiogramme in rechter Seitenlage. Verb. Deut. Ges. inn. Med, 1936, 48. Kongr, 318-23.— Schwab, R. Experiiiwntelle Untersuchungen Uber die Entste- hung des Infarktbildcs im Extremitaten-EKG. Zschr. ges. exp. Med, 1938, 103: 1-50. Weicker, B, & Hoenig, M. Elektro- kardiographische Beobachtungen beim Herzinfarkt. Zschr. Kreislaufforsch., 1935, 27: 337-45.—Weinberg, H. B, & Katz, I, N. A common electrocardiographic variant following acute myocardial infarction; the T* type. Am. Heart J, 1941, 21: 699-712.—Whitten, M. It. Midaxillary leads of the electro- cardiogram in myocardial infarction. Ibid, 1937, 13: 701-22.— Willius, F. A. Myocardial infarction; an electrocardiographic study; a report of 9 cases from the Mayo Clinic and a review of 24 published cases. J. Lab. Clin. M, 1924-25, 10: 427-45.— Wilson, F. N, & Johnston, F. D. The occurrence in angina pectoris of electrocardiographic changes similar in magnitude and in kind to those produced bv myocardial infarction. Am. Heart J, 1941, 22: 64-74—Wilson, F. N., Johnston, F. D. [et al] The electrocardiogram in the later stages of experi- mental mvocardial infarction. Tr. Ass. Am. Phvs, 1933, 48: 154-63. Also Proc. Soc. Exp. Biol, N. Y, 1933, 30: 799-801.— Wilson, F. N, Hill, I. G. W., & Johnston, F. D. The form of the electrocardiogram in experimental myocardial infarction; the later effects produced by ligation of the anterior descending branch of the left coronary artery. Am. Heart J, 1934—35, 10: 903; 1025.—Wilson, F. N, Macleod, A. G. [et al] The electro- cardiogram in myocardial infarction with particular reference to the initial deflections of the ventricular complex. Heart, Lond, 1933, 16: 155-76, 12 pl—Winternitz, M. The initial complex of the electrocardiogram after infarction of the human heart. Am. Heart J, 1934, 9: 616-41.—Wolferth, C. C, & Wood, F. C. Acute cardiac infarction involving anterior and posterior surfaces of left ventricle; electrocardiographic charac- teristics. Arch. Int. M, 1935, 56: 77-87. ------ The electro- cardiographic diagnosis of cardiac infarction. Mod. Concepts Card. Dis, 1935, 4: No. 5, 1; No. 6, 1. ------ Huge T-waves in precordial leads in cardiac infarction. Am. Heart J, 1934, 9: 706-21.—Zwillinger, L. Atypische Elektrokardiogramme im akuten Stadium des Myokardinfarktes. Zschr. klin. Med, 1937, 132: 689-94. ---- Infarction: Etiology. See also names of primary diseases. Achard, C. Infarctus thrombo-phtebitique du coeur. Rev. gen. chn. ther, 1934, 48: 177-83.—Altnow, H. O, & Rogers, R. G. Coronary thrombosis with myocardial infarction and pre- existing complete heart block; report of a case. Nicollet CUn Bull, 1941-^2, 2: 29-31.—Bean, W. B. Infarction of the heart: a morphological and clinical appraisal of 300 cases; predisposing and precipitating conditions. Am. Heart J, 1937, 14: 684- 702.—Bickel & Mozer. Infarto tromb6sico del corazon. Med. ibera, 1932, 26: 170-90.—Bizzozero, R. C. Oclusi6n coronaria e infarto de miocardio. Dfa med, B. Air, 1936, 8: 688-92.— Blumgart. H. L, Gilligan. D. R, & Schlesinger, M. J. Experi- mental studies on the effect of temporary occlusion of coronary arteries; the production of myocardial infarction. Am. Heart J, 1941, 22: 374-89.—Blumgart. H. L, Schlesinger. M. J, & Zoll, P. M. Angina pectoris, coronary failure and acute myo- cardial infarction; the role of coronary occlusions and collitcral circulation. J. Am. M. Ass, 1941, 116: 91-7. Boas, F, P. Angina pectoris and cardiac infarction from trauma or unusual effort with a consideration of certain medicolegal aspects. Ibid, 1939, 112: 1887-92.------Cardiac infarction induced by unusual effort. J. Mount Sinai Hosp. N. York, 1940-41, 7: 307-9. •------■ Some immediate causes of cardiac infarction. Am. Heart J, 1942, 23: 1-15.—Boumard, G, & Heim de Balsac. R. Ectasie aortique et infarctus du myocarde. Arch. mal. cceur, 1938, 31: 467-72.- Brandenburg, K. Koronar- sklerose und Myokardinfarkt. Med. Klin, Berl, 1931, 27: 539-41.—Camara, A. A sindrome clinica da obstruciio coro- naria e do infarto cardiaco. Rev. med. mil, Rio, 1936, 25: 17-22.—Casuso, A. Contribuci6n al estudio de la trombosis de las arterias coronarias con infarcto del miocardio. Vida nueva Habana, 1031. 28: 302 38— Corrigan, M. ('. Myocardial infarcts and syphilitic aortitis. Urol Cut. Hev, 1941, 45: 229-35.—Dassen, R, & Vitale, A. J. Infarto dc miocardio en la evoluci6n de un carcinoma br6nquico. Sem. med, B. Air, 1939, 46: 952-6.—Dietrich, A. Kranzgefassklerose und Herz- infarkt nach Analyse eines Einzelfalles. Frankf. Zschr. Path, 1935, 48: 456-63.—Eckerstrom, S. [Coronary thrombosis— infarct of the heart] Sven. lak. tidn.. 1938, 3.r>: 11-22.—Ellis, R. W. B. Infarcts and aneurysm of heart in an infant of 9 months: specimen. Proc. R. Soc. M, Lond, 1934-35, 28: 1333.—Friedberg, C. K, & Horn, H. Acute myocardial in- farction not due to coronary artery occlusion. J. Am. M. Ass, 1939, 112: 1675-9.—Gasbarrini, A, & Casanova, F. Infarto del miocardio da coronarite sinistra di natura arterio-sclerotica, e luetica, in soggetto diabetico. Policlinico, 1939, 46: sez. prat, 3-11.—Gonzalez Sabathie, L. Syndrome cUnique d'infarctus du mvocarde par hemopericarde. Arch. mal. cceur, 1935, 28: 449-58.—Gross, H, & Sternberg, W. H. Myocaridal infarction without significant lesions of coronary arteries. Arch. Int. M, 1939, 64: 249-67.—Hallermann, A. Herzinfarkt und Peri- karditis epistenocardica. Deut. Arch. klin. Med, 1931, 170: 146-9.—Herrmann, G. Coronary thrombosis and cardiac infarction. Internat. Clin, 1937, 47. ser, 3: 139-58, 5 pl— Hughes, T. A, & Mohammad Yusuf. Infarction of the heart with pericardial effusion in a young phthisical subject. Brit. M. J, 1931, 1: 794.—Lopez Fernandez, F. Infarto cardfaco y diabetes Q3 coronariana. Arch. med. int., Habana, 1939, 5: 277-88.—Lutembacher, R. Coronarite et infarctus sous- endocardiques k forme embolique. Arch. mal. coeur, 1926, 19: 505-12. ■------ Infarctus septique du myocarde au coura d'une endocardite maUgne secondaire. Presse med, 1939, 47: 273.—Master, A. M. Angina pectoris and cardiac infarction from trauma. J. Am. M. Ass, 1939, 113: 440. Also repr. ------Dack, S, & Jaffe, H. L. Age, sex and hypertension in myocardial infarction due to coronary occlusion. Arch. Int. M, 1939, 64: 767-86. Also repr.—May, W. J. Coronary infarction in young adults. S. Afr. M. J, 1936, 10: 772-4.— Medlar, E. M. Early cardiac infarction caused by an embolus of caseous tuberculous material; report of a case. Am. J. Path, 1935, 11: 707-9, pl.—Mentl, S. [Infarction of the myocardium in syphilitics] Cas. 16k. 6esk, 1940, 79: 953-61.—Mortensen, M. A. Infarcts of cardiac origin. J. Michigan M. Soc, 1930, 29: 710-3.—Myocardial infarction due to coronary insuffi- ciency; chnico-pathological conference. N. York State J. M, 1941, 41: 2043-6.—Nordmann. Der HerzmuskeUnfarkt als Folge funktioneller Kreislaufstorung. Zbl. inn. Med, 1936, 57: 548-50.—Paviot, J. Conditions etiologiques et pathogeniquea des infarctus du cceur, des grandes plaques de sclerose et dea coagulations adherentes intraventriculaires. J. nted. Lyon, 1932, 13: 33-54— Porto, J, & Soldati, L. de. Infarto de mio- cardio aparecido en un perro en avitaminosis Bi. Rev. Soc. argent, biol, 1939, 15: 426-33, 2 pl—Rathe, H. W. Sclerosia of the coronary arteries with myocardial infarction in a young woman. Am. Heart J, 1934, 9: 539-41.—Rathery, F, Bach- man, S, & Klotz, H. P. Infarctus du myocarde et hypochlo- remic. Bull. Soc. med. hop. Paris, 1937, 3. ser, 53: 789-92.— Schiassi, F. Infarto del cuore; contributo alio studio della coronarite reumatica. Arch, pat, Bologna, 1935-36, 15: 107- 30.—Smith, H. L, & Hinshaw, H. C. Acute coronary throm- bosis and myocardial infarction affecting a patient 31 years of age. Am. Heart J, 1937, 13: 741.—Velde, van de [Case of heart infarct] Geneesk. tschr. Ned. Indie, 1937, 77: 1252.— White, P. D, Glendy, R. E., & Gustafson, P. Myocardial infarction complicating pregnancy in a young woman. J. Am. M. Ass, 1937, 109: 863.—Zuidema [Heart infarct in an Indo- Chinese] Geneesk. tschr. Ned. Indie, 1941, 81: 1577. ----- [Infarct of the heart among the Javanese] Ibid, 2541-50. ---- Infarction: Manifestation. See also Angina pectoris; Heart arrhythmia, &c Bouyon, A. *Contribution a l'etude dea manifestations pericardiques dans l'infarctus du myocarde. 96p. 25cm. Lyon, 1938. Cabouat, A. *Les troubles psychiques de l'infarctus du myocarde [Paris] 47p. 24]/2cm. Cahors, 1939. Guillaume, II. A. *Infarctus du myocarde et claudication intermittcnte. 77p. 241/2cm. Par., 1938. HEART MUSCLE 333 HEART MUSCLE Gtjitj, E. A. F. *Les blocages partiels avec bradycardie ou cours des infarctus du myocarde. 51p. 24cm. Par., 1939. Miloikowitch, A. N. *Le syndrome angineux abdominal dans l'infarctus de la pointe du myocarde. 16p. 8? Geneve, 1927. Amargos, A. Sintomas y diagn6stico del infarto del mio- cardio. Arch. urug. med, 1934, 5: 77-94.—Arrillaga, F. C, & Taquini, A. C. Disociaciones auriculo ventriculares transitorias por infarto de miocardio. Rev. argent, card, 1934-35, 1: 362-70.—Aubertin, C, & Horeau, J. Infarctus du myocarde et claudication intermittente. Bull. Soc. med. hop. Paris, 1938, 3. ser, 54: 840-2.—Aubertin, C, & Lereboullet, J. L'asystolie tardive par cicatrice d'infarctus du myocarde. Monde med, 1931, 41: 605-14.—Babey, A. M. Painless acute infarction of the heart. N. England J. M, 1939, 220: 410-2.—Bascourret. Infarctus du myocarde k forme syncopale. Arch. mal. cceur, 1937, 30: 899-902.—Bean, W. B. Infarction of the heart; symptomatology of acute attack. Ann. Int. M, 1937-38, 11: 2086-108.—Berard, A. Un cas d'infarctus du myocarde avec tachycardie ventriculaire; survie prolongee. Arch. mal. coeur, 1940, 33: 50-4.—Bickel, G. Infarctus du myocarde a, type d'ictus apoplectique. Bull. Soc. med. hop. Paris, 1935, 3. ser, 51: 1532-8.—Bosco, G. La faUbiUdad del soplo merosist6Uco en el infarto de miocardio. Actas Congr. nac. med, Rosario, 1934,5: pt 4, 575-9. Also Arch. med. int., Habana, 1935, 1: 316-24.—Bullrich, R. A, & Moia, B. Aleteo auricular paroxfs- tico en un caso de infarto de miocardio. Rev. argent, card., 1937-38, 4: 28-36.—Chrzanowski, J, & Bender, A. [Painless forms of infarction of the myocardium] Warsz. czas. lek, 1936, 13: 141; 153.—Chvala, F. [Infarction of the myocardium with acute atrioventricular block] Cas. lek. fesk, 1934, 73: 1117.— Coelho, E. La tachycardie ventriculaire paroxystique dans l'infarctus du myocarde; etude de 2 cas. Arch, mal cceur, 1932, 25: 301-5. —----& Oliveira, A. de. Tachycardie et fibrilla- tion ventriculaires paroxystiques dans l'infarctus du myocarde. Cardiologia, Basel, 1939, 3: 169-81, 2 ch.—Coombs, C. F. Observations on the aetiological correspondence between anginal pain and cardiac infarction. Q. J. Med, Oxf, 1929-30, 23: 233-40.—Cossio, P., & Berconsky, I. Infarto de miocardio a forma de taquicardia paroxfstica ventricular. Sem. med, B. Air, 1932, 39: pt 2, 884.—Costedoat. Infarctus du myocarde k forme d'embarras gastrique febrile tecidivant. Bull. Soc. mid. hop. Paris, 1933, 3. ser, 49: 93-6.—Dalla Palma, M. SuU'infarto cardiaco a sintomatologia addominale. Policlinico, 1934, 41: sez. prat, 1369-75.—Davis, N. S, III. Cardiac infarction without history of pain. Med. Clin. N. America, 1932, 16: 315-23.—Diliberto, U. Angina pectoris ed infarto miocardico. Cuore & circol, 1934, 18: 505-11.—Donzelot, E, & Boucomont, R. L'infarctus du myocarde k forme angineuse. Presse med, 1930, 38: 314-6.—Donzelot, E, Meyer-Heine, A, & Pelaez, M. Troubles varies du rythme cardiaque chez un sujet atteint d'infarctus du myocarde. Arch. mal. coeur, 1939, 32: 573-80.—Doumer, E. Infarctus du myocarde k forme purement digestive. Bull Soc. med. hop. Paris, 1935, 3. ser, 51: 854-8.—Dumas, A, Froment, R, & Anstett, P. Tachy- cardie paroxystique ventriculaire symptomatique d'un infarctus myocardique de la cloison in ter-ventriculaire. Lyon med, 1932, 150: 200-9.—Eckerstrom, S. Hyperglycemic de type transitoire et glycosurie consecutives k un infarctus du myo- carde. Acta med. scand, 1938, 95: 528-38.—Edeiken, J., & Wolferth, C. C. Persistent pain in the shoulder region following myocardial infarction. Am. J. M. Sc, 1936, 191: 201-10.— Ernstene, A. C, & Kinell, J. Pain in the shoulder as a sequel to myocardial infarction. Arch. Int. M, 1940, 66: 800-6 — Esser, A. Ausgedehnter frischer Myokardinfarkt ohne Angina pectoris. Zschr. Kreislaufforsch, 1932, 24: 34-9.—Fogelson, L. I. [Angina pectoris and infarct of the myocardium] KUn. med, Moskva, 1938, 16: 1284-99.—Friedman, R, & Master, A. M. Heart sounds in myocardial infarction due to acute coronary occlusion. Proc. Soc. Exp. Biol, N. Y, 1941, 46: 574-6.—Gallavardin, L, & Froment, R. Infarctus du myocarde i forme de tachycardie paroxystique ventriculaire. Arch. mal. cceur, 1931, 24: 593-604.—Gambaro, B. Infarto del mio- cardio con blocco di branca destra. Cuore & circol, 1937, 21: 482-9.—Govea Pefia, J. Infarto cardiaco y taquicardia ven- tricular terminal. Rev. cienc. med, Habana, 1939, 2: 10-2.— Hoist, J. E. [Infarctus myocardu] Bibl. laeger, 1935, 127: 194; 221. ■------ Myokardinfarkt (eine symptomatologische und diagnostische Uebersicht an Hand von 28 Beobachtungen) Zschr. kUn. Med, 1935, 128: 130-62.—Infarto mioc&rdico sin dolor. Dfa med, B. Air, 1940, 12: 805.—Jorge, A. L. In- farctus du myocarde et bradycardie transitoire; remarques cUniques et electrocardiographiques. Presse med, 1933, 41: 1251-4.—Kennedy, J. A. The incidence of myocardial in- farction without pain in 200 autopsied cases. Am. Heart J, 1937, 14: 703-9.—Kervarec. Les formes silencieuses de l'infarctus du myocarde. Bull. Soc. med. Paris, 1931, 682-4.— Kjaergaard, H. Cerebral symptoms in acute myocardial in- farction. Acta med. scand, 1936, 88: 196-203.—Kourilsky, R, & Marchal, M. Sur une forme presque latente d'infarctus du myocarde. Bull. Soc. med. hop. Paris, 1935, 3. ser, 51: 1046- 58.—Landau, E. [CUnical syndrome of infarction of the myocardium] Warsz. czas. lek, 1936, 13: 383; 404; 4291 — Langeron, L. Infarctus du myocarde avec dissociation auriculo- ventriculaire complete. Arch. mal. coeur, 1938, 31: 638-41. ------ Signes cliniques et eiectriques d'infarctus cardiaque sans infarctus anatomique. Ibid, 1939, 32: 67-72.—Laubry, C Dissociation par infarctus larve. Ibid, 1937, 30: 894-6* ------ Infarctus du myocarde larve k forme febrile. Bull' Soc. med. hop. Paris, 1940, 56: 508-12. ------& Walser, J. Les formes camoufiees de l'infarctus du myocarde. Bull Acad' med. Par, 1935, 3. ser, 113: 314-20.—Lemaire, A. O infarctus do myocardio. Brasil med, 1929, 43: 1310.—LenSgre, J. Infarctus du myocarde avec bradycardie par dissociation auriculo-ventriculaire complete; disparition rapide des signes cliniques et eiectriques. Arch. mal. coeur, 1937, 30: 877-80 [Discussion] 896-9.—Le Roy. Un cas d'infarctus geant du myocarde, avec syndrome abdominal trompeur. Arch med pharm. nav, 1933, 123: 557-64.—Levin, E, & Ocafia, t! Infarto de miocardio a forma digestiva con ritmo septal; pequenos infartos multiples. Rev. argent, card, 1937-38, 4: 264-70.—Lian, C, & Puech, P. L'infarctus du myocarde et l'angor aigu coronarien febrile. Bull. Soc. med. hop. Paris 1928, 3. ser, 52: 318-36.—Lowe, T. E. Blood pressure changes following localized myocardial death. Med. J. Australia, 1941, 2: 447-51.—Lukomsky, P. E. [Disorders of the heart rhythm in cardiac infarction] Ter. arkh, 1940, 18: 286-95.—Master, A. M„ Jafle, H. L, & Dack, S. Sudden profund acrocyanosis as the presenting sign in myocardial infarction. J. Mount Sinai Hosp. N. York, 1937-38, 4: 21-3. Also repr. ------ Conduction disturbances in coronary artery occlusion with myocardial infarction. Mod. Concepts Card. Dis, 1939, 8: No. 7, 1. Also repr.—Papp, C. Infarto miocardico senza dolore. Cuore & circol, 1934, 18: 565-75.—Pollard, H. M., & Harvill, T. H. Painless myocardial infarction. Am. J. M. Sc, 1940, 199: 628-35. Also repr.—Regnier & Renders. Periodes de Luciani-Wenckebach au cours d'un infarctus du myocarde. Arch. mal. cceur, 1939, 32: 266-75.—Samain, L. Infarctus du myocarde et tachycardie ventriculaire. Ibid, 1937, 30: 700-6.—Soulie, P, & Gerbeaux, J. Volumineux infarctus du myocarde; apparition brusque d'un souffle systoli- que par thrombose ventriculaire. Ibid, 1938, 31: 625-30. —---- Notes k propos des souffles systoliques dans la sympto- matologie de certains infarctus du myocarde. Gaz. med. France, 1939, 46: 20,5-7.—Szczeklik, E. [Disorders of ventric- ular conductibility in infarct of the myocardium] Polsk. arch. med. wewn, 1939, 17: 397-423, ch.—Szekely, P. Tachycardie ventriculaire et blocage partiel au cours de l'infarctus du myocarde; avec une observation personnelle. Arch. mal. cceur, 1939, 32: 887-92.—Urban, J. [Disturbances of rhythm and of the circulatory system in infarct of the myocardium] Cas. lek. cesk., 1941, 80: 366-70.—Velasco Lombardini, R. La falta de signos subjetivos en el infarto miocardico; disturbio de conduccion intra-ventricular registrado electro-cardio- gr&Jicamente en el momento de producirse. In Libro de oro (M. R. Castex; B. Air, 1939, 3: 1444r-8— Vesa, A. Herzin- farkt und paroxysmale Tachykardie. Acta Soc. med. Duo- decim, 1938-39, ser. B, 26: No. 7, 1-1L—Willius, F. A. Acute cardiac infarction without pain: report of a case. Proc. Mayo Clin, 1934, 9: 409.—Wollheim, E. Herzinfarkt und Angina pectoris. Deut. med. Wschr, 1931, 57: 617-9. ---- Infarction: Pathology, and physiopathol- ogy. Bock & Polach, K. von. *Das Verhalten der Blutkorperchensenkungsreaktion beim Herzin- farkt und der Angina pektoris. 23p. 21cm. Bresl., 1937. Lang, R. *Der Myocardinfarkt; ein Kreislauf- und Stoffwechselproblem [Leipzig] 17p. 21cm. Wiirzb., 1937. Sittel, H. *Ueber die Storungen des Kohle- hydratstoffwechsels beim akuten Myokardin- farkt [Rostock] 34p. 21cm. Bochum, 1937. Barnes, A. R, & Ball, R. G. The incidence and situation of myocardial infarction in 1,000 consecutive postmortem exami- nations. Proc. Mayo Clin, 1930, 5: 367-9.—Bickel, G, Mozer, J, & Sciclounoff, F. La sedimentation globulaire dans l'infarctus du myocarde; sa signification, diagnostique et pronostique. Arch. mal. coeur, 1935, 28: 73-85.—Cabarron, F. G, Gofialons, G. P, & Rodrigue, C. Consideraciones sobre un caso de infarto miocardico y de la arteria mesenterica. Cr6n. med. mex, 1934, 33: 263-7.—Costero, I. Evoluci6n anat6mica de los infartos del miocardio. Arch. lat. amer. card, Mex, 1940, 10: 147-54.------■ Algunos datos sobre la evoluci6n anat6mica de los infartos del miocardio. Ciencia, Mex, 1940, 1: 348.—Dogliotti, G. C, & Beretta, A. Sul quadro emodinamico in due casi di infarto miocardico. Cuore & circol, 1939, 23: 235-45.—Fishberg, A. M., Hitzig, W. M., & King, F. H. Circulatorv dynamics in myocardial infarction. Arch. Int. M, 1934, 54: 997-1019.—Fracassi, T, & Ruiz, F. R. Un caso de infarto cardfaco comprobado en la autopsia. Rev. med. Rosario, 1929, 19: 321-32, 9 pl—Gomez, D. M, & Puente Veloso, S. Estudio clinico y experimental sobre el infarto del miocardio. Med. ibera, 1931, 15: 593-9.—Guizetti, H. U, & Sittel, H. Der Herzinfarkt und seine Auswirkungen auf den Kohlehydratstoffwechsel. Deut. Arch. klin. Med, 1937, 180: 500-11.—Harrington, A. W, & Wright, J. H. Cardiac infarction: a study of 148 cases. Glasgow M. J, 1933, 119: 1-12.—Hermann, G., & Decherd, G. ' Creatine and glycogen content of normal and infarcted heart muscle of the dog. Proc. HEART MUSCLE 334 HEART MUSCLE Soc. Exp. Biol, X. Y, 1934-35, 32: 1304.—Hermann, G, & Erhard, P. Total creatinine, phosphates, calcium and po- tassium in normal and infarcted myocardium of the dog. Ibid, 1938, 38: 3.5-7— Jochweds, B., Pbmskier, M. [et al.J [Case of multiple painless infarct of the cardiac muscle] YS arsz. czas. lek, 1937, 14: 365-7.—Laubry, ('., lesions et son mecanisme. Paris med, 1940, 115: 2i9-26.—Leriche. R, ^ Fontaine, R. Contribution a. l'etude experimentale de l'infarctus du myocarde. Stras- bourg med, 1932, 92: ^23-5.—Lisa, J. R, & McPeak, E. Acute miliary infarction of the heart. Arch. Int. M, 1940, 65: 919-32. Also repr.—Lisa, J. R, & Ring, A. Myocardial infarction or gross fibrosis; analysis of 100 necropsies. Ibid, 1932, 50: 131-41.—Lourenco Jorge, A. Infarto my ocardio; a definicao de infarto do my ocardio; a circulacao de my ocardio; dados anatomicos e physiologicos; anatomia pathologica do infarto do myocardio; pathogenia. Brasil med, 1932, 46: 957-61.—Lyon, R. M. M. Myocardial infarction, a patho- logical study. Edinburgh M. J, 1938, 45: 285-93.—McNee, J. W. Discussion on cardiac infarction. Tr. M. Soc. London, 1930, 53: 234-50, 4 pl—Master, A. M, Gubner, R. [et al] Form of ventricular contraction in cardiac infarction; fluoro- scopic studies. Proc. Soc. Exp. Biol, N. Y, 1939, 41: 89-94. Also repr.—Mitchell, A. G„ & Speckman, R. N. Local sclerosis (healed infarct) of the heart in an infant. Am. Heart J, 1926- 27, 2: 331-5.—Paliard, F, Viallier, J, & Muller, B. Gros cceur avec asystolie irteductible par petits infarctus myocardi- ipie-; gomme du rein decouverte k 1'autopsie. Lyon med, I'.tis. 162: 225-9.—Pomodoro, I. G. Sul comportamento del l! icogene nelle zone di miocardio colpite da infarto sperimentale. I isiol & med, Roma, 1933, 4: 401-6.—Putnoky, J., & Farkas, K. Vergleichende pathologisch-histologische Untersuchung des lleizmu>kels bei 1009 Obduktionen, unter besonderer Beach- tung der Falle von Thrombosen und EmboUen. Virchows Arch, 1932-33, 287: 400-4.—Research on cardiac infarction. J. Am. M. Ass, 1934, 103: 356.—Schwab, R, & Gopfert, K. Ueber die Entstehung des Herzinfarkts. Erg. inn. Med. Kinderh, 1939, 57: 297-350.—Shookhoff, C, Douglas, A. H, & Rabinowitz, M. A. Sedimentation time in acute cardiac infarction. Ann. Int. M, 1936, 9: 1101-5.—Sutton, D. C, & Davis, M. D. Effects of exercise on experimental cardiac infarction. Arch. Int. M, 1931, 48: 1118-25. Also repr — Travell, J, Gold, H, Modell, W. The blood pressure and the size of a cardiac infarct. Am. Heart J, 1938, 15: 448-51.— Whitten, M. B. The relation of the distribution and structure of the coronarv arteries to myocardial infarction. Arch. Int. M, 1930, 45: 383-400. Also repr.—Worsaae, E. [Infarctus myocardn; data from autopsy findings from patients above 60 years of age] Nord. med, 1940, 8: 1751-8.—Zimmermann- Meinzingen, O. Storungen des Kohlehydratstoffwechsels im Verlaufe von Gefiisserkrankungen; Storungen der Kohle- hydratstoffwechsels beim akuten Myokardinfarkt. Zschr. klin. Med, 1935-36, 129: 280-9. ---- Infarction: Prognosis. Boulay, J. *A propos du pronostic eloigne de l'infarctus du myocarde [Paris] 24p. 25cm. Vanves, 1939. Horvilleur, P. Contribution a l'etude du pronostic de l'infarctus du myocarde. 70p. 24cm. Par., 1939. Kruger, E. *Klinisch-elektrokardiographi- sche Nachuntersuchungen von 14 geheilten Herz- infarkten [Berlin] 31p. 23cm. Charlottenb., 1937. Bickel, G., & Mozer, J. Considerations sur la curabiUte clinique et anatomique de l'infarctus du myocarde. Rev. med. Suisse rom, 1935, 55: 94-102, pl—Bosco, G. El pron6stico clinico en el infarto de miocardio. Actas Congr. nac. med, Rosario, 1934, 5: pt 4, 562-70.—Cowan, J. The prognosis after an infarct of the heart. Tr. R. Med. Chir. Soc. Glasgow, 1935-36, 30: 30-5. Also Lancet, Lond, 1936, 1: 356-9.— Donzelot, E. Trois cas de guerison clinique d'infarctus du myocarde. Bull. Soc. med. hop. Paris, 1928, 3. ser, 52: 179- 186.— Hochrein, M, & Schneyer, K. Das Schicksal des Myo- kardinfarktes. Zschr. Kreislaufforsch, 1936, 28: 257-68.— Israel, J. E. El pronostico del infarto de miocardio. In Libro de oro (M. R. Castex) B. Air, 1940, 1: 569-80.—Levine, S. A, & Rosenbaum, F. F. Prognostic value of various clinical and electrocardiographic features of acute myocardial infarction; ultimate prognosis. Arch. Int. M, 1941, 68: 1215-31.— Mallory, G. K, White, P. D, & Salcedo-Salgar, J. The speed of healiug of myocardial infarction; a study of the pathologic anatomy in 72 cases. Am. Heart J, 1939, 18: 647-71.— Mentl, S. [Prognosis of infarct of the myocardium] Cas. lek. Cesk, 1931, 80: 7; 59— Mladek, A. [Infarction of the myo- cardium in convalescence] Ibid, 1931, 70: 1583-7.—Padilla, R, & Cossio, P. Pron6stico del infarto de miocardio. Actas Congr. nac. med, Rosario, 1934, 5: pt 4, 613-20. Also Rev. argent, card, 1934-35, 1: 181-91. Also Sem. med, B. Air 1934, 41: pt 2, 1080-3.—Raevskaia, G. A. [Disability prog- nosis in infarct of the myocardium] Ter. arkh, 1938, 16: No. 1-2, 50-9.—Rosenbaum, F. F, & Levine, S. A. Prognostic value of various clinical and electrocardiographic features of acute myocardial infarction; immediate prognosis. Arch. Int. M, 1941, 68: 913-44.—Serf, J. [Prognostic value of the electrocardiogram in infarct of the myocardium] Cas. ldk. 6esk, 1937, 76: IBs I-7.—Willius, F. A. A talk on the healing of cardiac infarcts. Proc. Mayo Clin, 1937, 12: 218. ----— factors influencing recovery in cases of acute myocardial infarction. Ibid, 1941, 16: 456-9. Also Hev. med. Veracruz, 1911, 21: 3568-71. ------ & Barnes, A. R. Recovery after cardiac infarction. Med. Clin. N. America, 1931, 15: 69-77. ---- Infarction: Radiography. KXlmXn, A. *Das Rontgenbild des Herzin- farktes [Zurich] 16p. 23y2cm. Budap., 1940. Wohlmtjth, H. *Semiologic radiologique de l'infarctus du myocarde. 47p. 24^cm. Par, 1939. Dack, S, Sussman, M. L, & Master, A. M. The roentgen- kymogram in myocardial infarction; the abnormalities in left ventricular contraction. Am. Heart J, 1940, 19: 453-63. ------ The roentgenkymogram in myocardial infarction; clinical and electrocardiographic correlation. Ibid, 464-74. Also repr.—Gubner, R, & Crawford, J. H. Roentgenkymo- graphic studies of myocardial infarction. Ibid, 1939, 18: 8-24.—Heim de Balsac, R. Intetes de la anatomia radiol6gica en cardiologia, a proposito de un caso de infarto del miocardio. Arch. lat. amer. card, Mex, 1936, 6: 207-25.—Helstein, E. M, & Ivanitskaia, M. A. [Development of coronary thrombosis (infarction of the myocardium) from the view-point of roentgen- kymography] Ter. arkh, 1937, 15: 767-83, 2 pl-Latypov, K. N. [Significance of roentgenokymography in diagnosis of infarcts of the myocardium] Kazan, med. J, 1939, 35: No. 8, 57-61, pl—Master, A. M. Fluoroscopic diagnosis of myo- cardial infarction following coronary occlusion. J. Mount Sinai Hosp. N. York, 1939-40, 6: 18-24. Also repr. ----- Gubner, R. [et al] The diagnosis of coronary occlusion and myocardial infarction by fluoroscopic examination. Am. Heart J, 1940, 20: 475-85.—Perona, P. Infarto miocardico e segni di coronarite nella diagnostica roentgenchimografica. Cuore & circol, 1940, 24: 41-57.—Routier, D, Heim de Balsac, R. [et al] Etude anatomo-radiologique de 3 cas d'infarctus du myocarde. Presse med, 1936, 44: 1129-32.—Sussman, M. L. Roentgenkymography in the diagnosis of myocardial infarct; with normal electrocardiograms. J. Mount Sinai Hosp. N. York, 1939-40, 6: 130-3- ---- Infarction: Treatment, and prevention. See also Coronary artery, Thrombosis: Treat- ment; Syphilis, cardiovascular, &c. Bellet, S, Johnston, C. G, & Schecter, A. Effect of cardiac infarction on the tolerance of dogs to digitalis; an experimental study. Arch. Int. M, 1934, 54: 509-16.—Blumberger, K. Therapie des Mvokardinfarkts. Med. Klin, Berl, 1938, 34: 397-9.—Ciaburri, A. D, Godio, L, & Arana, E. L. Trata- miento del infarto del miocardio. Dia med, B. Air, 1939, 11: 481-5.—Clerc, A, & Deschamps, P. N. Traitement de l'in- farctus myocardique. J. med. fr, 1930, 19: 71.—Donzelot, E, & Olivier, J. Diagnostic et traitement de l'infarctus du myo- carde. J. med. chir. Par, 1935, 106: 714-9.—Eckardt, P. ExperimenteUe Untersuchungen zur Frage der Therapie des Herzinfarkts. Verh. Deut. Ges. inn. Med, 1938, 50. Kongr, 141-5.—Fowler, W. M., Hurevitz, H. M, & Smith, F. M. Effect of theophylUne ethylenediamine on experimentally induced cardiac infarction in the dog. Arch. Int. M, Chic, 1935, 56: 1242-9.—Gold, H, Travell, J., & Modell, W. The effect of theophylline with ethylenediamine (aminophylUne) on the course of cardiac infarction foUowing experimental coronary occlusion. Am. Heart J, 1937, 14: 284-96.—Grotel, D. M. [Certain questions in the treatment of acute infarct of the myocardium] KUn. med, Moskva, 1939, 17: No. 6, 14-31. Also Ter. arkh, 1939, 17: No. 6, 23-39.—Harrison, T. R. The management of patients with acute myocardial infarction. Kentucky M. J, 1940, 38:442-6.—Hassencamp, E. Auf den Herzinfarkt und seine Behandlung. Med. Welt, 1940, 14: 952.—Hochrein, M. Sobre la profilaxis del infarto del miocardio. Rev. med. germ. iber. amer, 1933, 6: 265-74. ------ Konnen wir die Entstehung des Myokardinfarktes verhuten? Munch, med. Wschr, 1933, 80: 1613-6. -----■ Richtlinien fiir die Behandlung des Myokardinfarktes. Ibid, 1935, 82: 1515-20.—Ibrahim Abdel Sayed. Relief of pain in cardiac infarction with oxygen. J. Egypt. M. Ass, 1934, 17: 454-7.—Leriche, R, & Fontaine, R. Essai experimental de traitement de certains infarctus du myocarde et de ran6vrisme du coeur par une greffe de muscle stri6. BuU. Soc. nat. chir. Par, 1933, 59: 229-32.—Leslie, A, Mulinos, M. G, & Scott, W. S, jr. Coronary occlusion; efficacy of papaverine hydro- chloride in treatment of experimental cardiac infarction. Proc. Soc. Exp. Biol, N. Y, 1940, 44: 625-8.—Lewis, T. K. Treatment of the acute stage of myocardial infarction; con- traindications to the use of morphine. J. M. Ass. Alabama, 1940-41, 10: 99-105.—Maldonado Allende, I. Tratamiento del infarto del miocardio y de la estenosis coronaria. Dia med, B. Air, 1940, 12: 835-42.—Mouquin, M. Traitement de l'infarctus du myocarde. Bull, med. Par, 1934, 48: 407- 12-—Penati, F, & Asinelli, C. L'impiego deUa strofuntina nei trattamento deU'infarto miocardico. Gazz. med. ital, 1937, 86: 51-3.—R. El suffato de quinidina en el infarto del mio- cardio. Dia m6d, B. Air., 1941, 13: 714.—Ravina. Infarctua HEART MUSCLE 335 HEART MUSCLE du myocarde; traitement par le chlorure de sodium. Union m6d. Canada, 1937, 66: 643.—Scremini, P., & Lrdampilleta, P. El sulfato de quinidina en la terapeutica del infarto del mio- cardio. Arch. urug. med, 1940, 17: 565-73.—Tamchfes, A. Action du chlorure de sodium dans les infarctus graves du myocarde. Presse med, 1937, 45: 263. Also Brasil med, 1937, 51: 460-2.—Travell, J, Gold, H, & Modell, W. Effect of experimental cardiac infarction on response to digitalis. Arch. Int. M, 1938, 61: 184-97.—Uraga, A. Tratamiento del infarto del miocardio. Arch. urug. med, 1934, 5: 95-105. Also Cr6n. med. mex, 1935, 34: 7-13. ---- Inflammation. See subheading Myocarditis ---- Inotropism. See subheading Contractility. ---- Insufficiency. See Heart failure, congestive. ---- Ischaemia. See also subheading Infarction. Dennis, J, & Moore, R. M. Potassium changes in the functioning heart under conditions of ischemia and of conges- tion. Am. J. Physiol, 1938, 123: 443-7.—Garrey, W. E, & Boykin, J. T. Inhibition of the heart under anaerobic condi- tions. Ibid, 1935, 111: 649-54.—Greene, C. W., & Gilbert, N. C. Studies on the responses of the circulation to low oxygen tension; the cause of the changes observed in the heart during extreme anoxemia. Air. Serv. Inform. Circ, 1922, 4: 37-54, 2 pl.—Katz, L. N, & Lindner, E. Quantitative relation between reactive hyperemia and the myocardial ischemia which it follows. Am. J. Physiol, 1939, 126: 283-8.—Legrand, R, & Nayrac, P. Myocardite interstitielle primitive d'origine ischemique. C. rend. Soc. biol, 1929, 100: 886-8.—Lopez Ramirez, R, & Nanclares, A. F. Muerte r&pida por isquemia miocardica. Dia med, B. Air, 1939, 11: 1018-20.—Tennant, R. Factors concerned in the arrest of contraction in an ischemic myocardial area. Am. J. Physiol, 1935, 113: 677-82.— Vannotti, A. Medikamentose Beeinflussung der Myokard- ischamie. Helvet. med. acta, 1938, 5: 665-70. ---- Metabolism [and nutrition] Clark, A. J., Eggleton, M. G. [et al.] The metabolism of the frog's heart. 308p. 8? Edinb., 1938. Schone, G. Ueber don Stoffwechsel des Warmbluterherzens [Habilitationsschrift] [Wurz- burg] p.551-80. 8? Berl., 1933. Also Zschr. ges. exp. Med, 1933, 89: Arvanitaki, A, & Cardot, H. Regimes devolution et tegimes irteguliers du tissu myocardique. Ann. physiol. Par, 1934, 10: 971-4— Barker, S. B, Furchgott, R. F„ & Shorr, E. Organic phosphate changes in resting cardiac muscle as indicated by radioactivity studies. Am. J. Physiol, 1941, 133: 202.—Bassani, R. Alcune precisazioni sul meta- bolismo del muscolo cardiaco. Arch, fisiol. Fir, 1933-34, 33: 390-401.—Bohnenkamp, H. Der Stoffwechsel des Herzens und seine Leistungsgrenzen. Verhber. Internat. Sportarzte- kongr. (1936) 1937, 2. Kongr, 59-74. Also Verh. Ges. Ver- dauungskr. (1936) 1937, 13: 60-75.—Bornstein, A, & Roese, H. F. Ueber Blutversorgung und Stoffwechsel des arbeitenden Saugetiermuskels; Versuche an der iiberlebenden Extremitat und am Herz-Lungen-Praparat. Arch. ges. Physiol, 1928-29, 221: 400-9.—Brody, H. The carbon dioxide dissociation curve of frog heart muscle. Am. J. Physiol, 1930, 93: 190-6.— Clark, A. J. Resting metabolism of the frog's ventricle. Q. J. Exp. Physiol, Lond, 1935-36, 25: 167-80. —--- Stewart, C. P., & Gaddie, R. The metabolism of the frog's isolated heart. Proc. R. Soc, Edinburgh, 1929-30, 50: 297-303. Also J. Physiol, Lond, 1931, 72: 443-66.—Cruickshank, E. W. H. Cardiac metaboUsm. Physiol. Rev, 1936, 16: 597r639. ------ & McClure, G. S. On the question of the utilization of amino acids and fat by the mammalian heart. J. Physiol, Lond, 1936, 86: 1-14.—Evans. C. A. L. Metab- oUsm of the heart. Edinburgh M. J, 1939, 46: 733-49. ------ The metabolism of cardiac muscle. In Recent Ad- vance. Physiol. (W. H. Newton) 5. ed, Lond, 1936, 33-85. Also 6. ed. 1939, 157-215.—Galwialo, M. J, & Kreines, C. J. VerteUung des Stickstoffs, Phosphors, Eisens und Schwefels in Myosinen und Myostrominen des Herzmuskels. Biochem. Zschr, 1930, 222: 123-34.— Joffe, E. L'action des produits du metabolisme du coeur sur le travail de cet organe. Arch. internat. physiol, Liege, 1931, 34: 305-21.—Lawson, H. The metabolism of cardiac muscle. Kentucky M. J, 1939, 37: 36-8.—Loeper, M. La nutrition du coeur. In his Semiol ther. Par, 1938, 70-8.—Lohmann, K, & Weicker, B. Stoff- wechsel des Herzens. In Handb. Biochem. (Oppenheimer, C.) Jena, 1936, 2. Aufl, Erganzw, 3: 414-30.—Navez, A. E, Crawford, J. D. [et al] On metabolism of the heart of Venus mercenaria. Biol. Bull, 1941, 81: 289.—Neuschlosz, S. M. Untersuchungen uber die KaUumbindung in der Kammer- muskulatur und ihre Bedeutung fur die Herzfunktion. Arch ges. Physiol, 1926, 213: 19-39.-Noyons, A. K. M. Le role du calcium au point de vue de l'oxybiose du coeur. C. rend Soc. biol, 1926, 95: ceiebr. 75e anniv, 44-6 ------ Die kontinuierhche Bestimmung des Umsatzes im Herz-Lungen- Praparat. Acta brevia neerl, 1937, 7: 163.—Savitsky, N N £ieart action and basal metabolism] Tr. Acad. mil. med! Kiroff, 1935, 4: 107-13.-Visscher, M. B. Fat metabolism of the isolated heart. Proc. Soc. Exp. Biol, N. Y, 1938, 38: 323-5—Weizzacker, V. von. Methodik der Stoffwechsel- ^ueJrSUiC,jngerV,^nir,Herzen- In Handb. biol. Arbeitsmeth. (Abderhalden, E.) Berl, 1927, Abt. 5, T. 4, 1020-46.—Wendt, L.. b-1 depression as a sign of anaerobic cardiac metaboUsm Am. Heart J 1941, 22: 841 (Abstr.)— Wertheimer, E. Beitrag zur Frage des Stoffumsatzes beim schlagenden Kaltbluter- herzen. Arch. ges. Physiol, Berl, 1930, 225: 429; passim. ---- Metabolism: Disorder. Aszodi, Z, & Sas, L. [Experiments on the sugar consump- tion of the heart of normal, C-hypervitaminotic and skorbutic guinea-pigs] Magy. orv. arch, 1939, 40: 177-82.—Binet, L., Strumza, M. V., & Ordonez, J. H. Coeur et anoxic Arch. mal coeur, 1938, 31: 11-6.—Bong, E, Junkersdorf, P, & Steinborn, H. Untersuchungen uber das Gewicht und die chemische Zusammensetzung des Herzens unter physiologischen und pathologischen Bedingungen; ein Beitrag zur Physiologie und Pathologie des Herzstoffwechsels; Versuche an Hunden mit AppUkation von korperfremden und korpereigenen Stoffen und im pankreasdiabetischen Zustand. Zschr. ges. exp Med 1933-34, 92: 573-97.—Decherd, G, Herrmann, G, & Erhard! P. Effect of myocardial destructive agents on creatine con- tent of the rabbit's heart. Proc. Soc. Exp. Biol, N. Y, 1933- 36, 33: 519.—Fieschi, A. Ricerche sul chimismo del muscolo cardiaco; la glicogenolisi del muscolo cardiaco negU stati ipertiroidei sperimentaU. Cuore & circol, 1932, 16: 337.— Frey, W., & Tiemann, F. Untersuchungen uber die Phos- phatabgabe des normalen und geschadigten Froschherzens. Zschr. ges. exp. Med, 1926-27, 53: 639-57.—Gollwitzer-Meier, K. Zur Frage einer Sauerstoffschuld des Warmbluterherzens. Arch. ges. Physiol, 1939, 242: 691-9.—Moore, R. M, & Greenberg, M. M. Acid production in the functioning heart under conditions of ischemia and of congestion. Am. J. Physiol, 1937, 118: 217-24.—Moroni, M. Modificazioni del volume del cuore durante l'asfissia acuta nella intossicazione sperimentale. Gazz. osp, 1937, 58: 321-5.—Schumann, H. Zur Frage einer Sauerstoffschuld im Herzen bei vermehrter mechanischer Arbeit. Klin. Wschr, 1939, 18: 507. ------ Die Verminderung des Glykogens, des Phosphagens und der Adenylpyrophosphorsaure im Herzmuskel bei Sauerstoff- mangel und nach ermudender Arbeit normaler und trainierter Tiere. Zschr. ges. exp. Med, 1939, 106: 59-66. ---- Metabolism, gaseous. Arnoldi, W., & Hiraoka, T. Untersuchungen iiber die At- mung des Froschherzens; der Einfluss von Saure und Lauge auf den Os Verbrauch des iiberlebenden Froschherzens. Bio- chem. Zschr, 1928, 193: 203-6.—Bauer, L. Stoffwechsel- untersuchungen am Kaltbluterherzen; iiber den Sauerstoff - verbrauch des Herzens bei wechselnder, angenahert isotonischer Arbeit. Zschr. Biol, 1929-30, 89: 513-22.—Bohnenkamp, H., Eismayer, G, & Ernst, W. Die Energieumwandlungen im Herzmuskel; Arbeit und Sauerstoffverbrauch des Froschherzens. Ibid, 1927-28, 87: 489-97— Brody, H. The anaerobic oxygen debt and the anaerobic carbon dioxide production of frog cardiac muscle. J. Cellul. Physiol, 1934, 4: 297-312.—Burns, W, & Cruickshank, E. W. H. Changes in creatine, phosphagen and adenylpyrophosphate in relation to the gaseous metabolism of the heart. J. Physiol, Lond, 1937-38, 91: 314-28 — Casser, H. Herzarbeit ohne Sauerstoff; Hemmung der Blau- saurewirkung durch Dioxyazeton und Glyzerinaldehyd. Arch. exp. Path, Lpz, 1930, 149: 240-6.—Eismayer, G, & Quincke, H. Stoffwechseluntersuchungen am Kaltbluterherzen; Sauer- stoffverbrauch, Kohlensaure- und Milchsaure-Abgabe des Herzens bei verschiedener Arbeit. Zschr. Biol, 1929-30, 89: 523-35. ------ Ueber den Einfluss des Sauerstoff angebotes und des Insulins auf den Gaswechsel des Herzens. Ibid, 1930, 90: 57-62.—Fenn, W. O. An oxidative reserve as source of anaerobic carbon dioxide in heart muscle. J. Cellul. Physiol, 1934-35, 5: 347-58.—Fernandez Cruz, A. El aporte de oxigeno al corazon y su patologia. Medicina, Madr, 1941, 9: pt 2, 101-15.—Freund, H, & Konig, W. Herzarbeit ohne Sauer- stoff. Arch. exp. Path, Lpz, 1927, 125: 193-211. Also Klin. Wschr, 1927, 6: 16.—Gollwitzer-Meier. Der Sauerstoff- verbrauch des Warmbluterherzens. Zbl. inn. Med, 1935, 56: 707. ------ & Kriiger, E. Einfluss der Herznerven auf den Gaswechsel des Warmbluterherzens. Arch. ges. Physiol, 1938, 240: 89-110.—Hiraoka, T. Untersuchungen fiber die Atmung des Froschherzens; fiber den O2-Verbrauch des iiberlebenden Froschherzens bei Speisung mit Ringer- sowie Tyrode- und Lockescher Losung. Biochem. Zschr, 1928, 193: 197-202 — Ishigami, H. Measuring a minute amount of oxygen and carbon dioxide in metabolism of a frog's heart. Jap. J. M. Sc, 1935-36, 9: Pharm, 81.—Kiese, M, & Garan, R. S. Mecha- nische Leistung, Grosse und Sauerstoffverbrauch des Warm- bluterherzens. Arch. exp. Path, Lpz, 1937-38, 188: 226-46. Also Klin. Wschr., 1937, 16: 1219.—McDonald, C. H., & McDonald, A. C. The rate of oxygen consumption of the HEART MUSCLE 336 HEART MUSCLE isolated terrapin heart when perfused with various solutions. Am. J. Physiol, 1935, 111: 51-4.—Melik-Megrabov, A. M. [On the respiratory metabolism of the normal heart] J. Physiol. USSR, 1934, 17: 89-95.—Noyons, A. K. M. Ringer- sche Losung und Sauerstoffbedurfnis des Aalherzens. Schweiz. med. Wschr, 1941, 71: 448-50.— Scheinfinkel, N. Die Ab- hangigkeit des Gaswechsels des Froschherzens von der Reiz- frequenz und die scheinbare Ermiidung des Froschherzens. Zschr. Biol, 1926, 84: 297-305.—Stella, G. The oxygen consumption of the tortoise heart; its dependence upon dia- stolic volume and on the mechanical conditions of systole. J. Physiol, Lond, 1931, 72: 247- 64.— Stern, K. G. Respiratory catalysts in heart muscle. Sympos. Quant. Biol, 1939, 7: 312-22. ---- Metabolism, glucid. Themanx, G. *Wirkung verschiedener Herz- praparate aus der Digitalis- und Kampfergruppe auf den Kohlehydrathaushalt des Kaninchen- herzens. 22p. 8: Bresl., 1938. Ambrus, G. [Sugar regulation of the heart of thyroidec- tomized and normal cats and in thyroidectomized cats, treated with thyroxin] Magy. orv. arch, 1929, 30: 125-9. Also Biochem. Zschr, 1929, 205: 194-213. ------ Beitrage zur Physiologie iiberlebender Saugetierherzen; vergleichende Be- stimmung des Zuckerverbrauchs iiberlebender Katzenherzen, ausgefiihrt mit iilteren Apparaten und mit dem verbesserten Locke-Rosenheimschen Apparat. Ibid, 1927, 185: 442-9.— Arning, D. The lactic acid maximum of cardiac muscle. J. Physiol, Lond, 1927-28, 63: 107-12—Aszodi, Z. Beitrage zur Physiologie iiberlebender Saugetierherzen; fiber den Zuckerverbrauch verschieden grosser Herzen als Funktion der Korperoberflache oder des Korpergewichts. Biochem. Zschr. 1927, 185: 450-69. ------ Ueber den Zuckerverbrauch der Herzen pankreasdiabetischer Katzen; fiber den Einfluss des Insulins auf den Zuckerverbrauch solcher Herzen. Ibid, 1928, 192: 14-25.—Banga, I, Laki, K, & Szent-Gyorgyi, A. Ueber die Oxydation der Milchsaure und der 0-Oxybuttersaure durch den Herzmuskel. Zschr. physiol, Chem, 1933, 217: 43; 220: 278.—Banga, I, Schneider, L, & Szent-Gyorgyi, A. Leber die Bedeutung der Milchsiiure fiir die Atmung des zerkleinerten Herzmuskelgewebes. Biochem. Zschr, 1931, 240: 478.— Bassani, B, A: Foffani, G. L'acido lattico nei metabolismo del muscolo cardiaco. Arch, fisiol, Fir, 1934, 33: 533-40.— Bogue, J. Y, F.vans, C. L, & Hsu, F. Y. The significance of lactic acid uptake by the mammalian heart. J. Physiol, Lond, 1935, 84: Suppl., 55.— Bogue, J. Y, Evans, C. L. [et al] The effect of adrenaline and of increased work on the carbohydrate metabolism of tie mammalian heart. Q. J. Exp. Physiol, Lond, 1935-30, 25: 213-28.—Clark, A. J, Gaddie, R, & Stewart, C. P. The carbohydrate metabolism of the isolated heart of the frog. J. Physiol, Lond, 1932, 75: 311-20 — Cristiani, E. Azione ed assorbimento del galattosio e del levulosio nei cuore di rana. Clin. med. ital, 1935, 66: 188- 94.—Eismayer, G, & Quincke, H. Stoffwechseluntersuchungen am Kaltbluterherzen; uber den Glykoseumsatz bei verschie- dener Arbeit. Zschr. Biol, 1928-29, 88: 139-44.—Evans, C. L, Grande, F, & Fong Yen Hsu. The glucose and lactate consumption of the dog's heart. Q. J. Exp. Physiol, Lond, 1934-35, 24: 347-64.—Gaddie, R, & Stewart, C. P. The anaerobic breakdown of carbohydrate in the isolated ventricle of the frog. J. Physiol, Lond, 1934, 80: 457-79.—Gemmill, C. L. Cardiac inhibition; the effect of vagal inhibition on the lactic acid content of the terrapin's heart. Am. J. Physiol, 1927-28, 83: 415-9.—Gottdenker, F, & Marchi, G. de. Ueber die Wirkung von Adrenalin und Sympatol auf den Milchsaure- stoffwechsel des Herzens. KUn. Wschr, 1937, 16: 1282-4.— Haendel, M, & Munilla, A. Studien fiber den Stoffwechsel des Herzmuskels; fiber das Herzglykogen. Biochem. Zschr, 1929, 212: 35-46. Also An. Fac. med, Montev, 1929, 14: 188-206.— Lasch, F, & Triger, K. Experimentelle Untersuchungen fiber die Beeinflussung des Kohlehydratgehaltes im Herzmuskel; direkt am Zuckerstoffwechsel angreifende Mittel. Zschr. ges. exp. Med, 1932-33, 85: 390-9.—Loeper, M., & Lemaire, A. Les reserves glycogeniques du cceur. C. rend. Soc. biol, 1929, 103: 209. Also Progr. med. Par, 1930, 45: 185. ------ & Mougeot, A. Le role du glycogene dans l'activite du cceur d'escargot. Ibid, 678.—Loeper, Mougeot, A. [et al] Glyco- gine du cceur et medicaments cardiaques. Ibid, 906.— McGinty, D. A. Studies on the coronary circulation; absorption of hetie acid by the heart muscle. Am. J. Physiol, 1931, 98: 244-54—Mononobe, K. Untersuchungen fiber den Stoff- wechsel des Herzens; fiber den Phosphorsaurewechsel des sauerstofrlos schlagenden iiberlebenden Kaltblfiterherzens. Fol. pharm. jap, 1930-31, 11: 1-40.—Montalto, A. Effetti della stimolazione del pneumogastrico sul contenuto inglicidi del cuore. Boll. Soc. ital. biol. sper, 1933, 8: 816-9.—Nagaya, T. Untersuchungen fiber Arbeitsgrosse und Saurebildung des Muskels; die Milchsaurebildung des frei schlagenden Frosch- herzens. Arch. ges. Physiol, 1928-29, 221: 733-41.—Ochoa, S. Enzymatische MUchsaurebildung in der Herzmuskulatur Biochem. Zschr, 1937, 290: 62-70.—Perger, H. Unter- suchungen fiber den Lactacidogenphosphorsaurewechsel im Herzmuskel. Zschr. physiol. Chem, 1926, 162: 122-35.— Pollack, H, Flock, E. [et al.] The effect of glucose on the creatine phosphate content of the dog's heart. Proc. Mayo Clin, 1933, 8: 521.—Pom6thy, R. Beitrage zur Physiologie uberlebender Saucetierherzen; fiber den Verbrauch der Katzen- herzen an verschiedenen Zuckerarten. Biochem. Zschr, 1933, 260: 102-2(H). Kicsscr. Ueber die Milchsfturebdldung dea freischlairrndt n I i ci-chherzens (nach Versuchen von Dr Nnjmyai Arch. exp. Path, Lpz, 1028, 138: 136.—Rolshoven, H. Untersuchungen uber den Milchsiiurestoffwechsel des isolierten Hundeherzens. Zschr. ges. exp. Mid, 1933, 90: 225-36.—Riihl, A, & Rolshoven, H. Untersuchungen fiber den Milchsiiurestoffwechsel des isolierten Hundeherzens, Klin. Wschr, 1933, 12: 776.—Sachs, L. Der Verbrauch an Kohlehydraten im Herzmuskel unter verschiedenen Ein- wirkungen und die daraus gezogenen Konsequenzen. Ausz. Inaugur. Diss. Med. Fak. Lniv. Bern, 1933-35, No. 94, L— Satoh, H. Experimentelles Studium der inneren Sekretion des Pankreas; Einfluss des Pankreashormons auf den Zucker- verbrauch des aus dem Organismus isolierten Hundeherzens, Tohoku J. Exp. M, 1929, 13: 292-302.—Scheinfinkel, N. Untersuchungen fiber die Abhangigkeit des Traubenzuckerver- brauches des iiberlebenden Froschherzens von der Grosse der vom ihm geleisteten Arbeit sowie von der Grosse der e.nzelnen das Arbeitsprodukt bildenden Faktoren. Zschr. Biol, 1935, 96: 178-84.—Scherf, D, & Weissberg, J. The influence of hypertonic glucose solution on the heart; a preliminary report. Bull. N. York M. Coll, 1939, 2: 41-6.—Sekiguchi, R. Ueber den Stoffwechsel der Phosphorsiiure des Herzmuskels. Jap. J. M. Sc, 1933-35, 3: Int. Med, 213-43. ------ Ueber den Kohlenhydratstoffwechsel des Herzmuskels. Ibid, 161-211, tab.—Sprague, P. H. Experimental studies on the glycogen content of the perfused heart of the rabbit. Am. J. Physiol, 1933, 105: 402-6.—Visscher, M. B, & Mulder, A. G. The carbohydrate metabolism in the heart. Ibid, 1930, 94: 630- 40.—Winter, L. B. Inositol metabolism in the mammalian heart. Biochem. J, Lond, 1934, 28: 6-10.—Yater, W. M, Osterberg, A. E, & Hefke, H. W. The chemical determination of the glycogen ratio of the heart muscle and the bundle of Hia in man. Proc. Mayo Clin, 1928, 3: 243. ---- Metabolism, protid. Lissak, K, & Hoyos, J. [A functional loss of proteins of the heart-muscle; the hindrance of the effect of oleinate on frog heart] Magy. orv. arch, 1936, 37: 305-10. ----- Ueber den Eiweissverlust des arbeitenden Herzmuskels. Arch. exp. Path, Berl, 1936, 181: 607-9.—Lissak, K., & Toro, I. [The source of protein liberated from the heart muscle] Magy. orv. arch, 1937, 38: 59-63. Also Arch. exp. Path, Berl, 1936, 183: 567-70.—Parnas, J. K, & Ostern, P. Ueber die Am- moniakbildung im isolierten Froschherzen. Biochem. Zschr, 1931, 134: 37-22. ---- Metabolism: Thermodynamics. Heilbrun, W. *Ueber Versuche zum Nach- weis der von den Oxydationen abhangigen Warmebildung im Froschherzen. 20p. 8? Heidelb., 1927. Bohnenkamp, H. [Thermodynamik des Herzens] Deut. med. Wschr, 1926, 52: 1837. ------ Die Energieumwand- lungen im Herzmuskel; fiber die Energetik und Thermodynamik der Kontraktionsphase. Zschr. Biol, 1926, 84: 79-117. Also Verh. Phys. med. Ges. Wurzburg, 1927, n. F, 52: 113-24. ------ Ueber die Energieumsetzung und den Energievorrat des Herzens. In Kreislauferkr. & ihre Behandl, Lpz, 1932, 18-25. ------ & Ernst, W. Die Energieumwandlungen im Herzmuskel; fiber die mechanischen Warmequellen des Frosch- herzens. Zschr. Biol, 1926, 84: 436-52. ------ Ueber die UnveranderUchkeit der Energieabgabe des Herzens. Deut. med. Wschr, 1928, 54: 347-9. ------ Die Energieumwand- lungen im Herzmuskel; fiber die wirkliche Grosse des Energie- umsatzes, seine Unabhangigkeit von der Arbeit und die Oeko- nomie derselben. Zschr. Biol, 1928-29, 88: 429-50.—Decherd, G, & Visscher, M. B. The relative importance of the per- formance of work and the initial fiber length in determining the magnitude of energy liberation in the heart. Am. J. Physiol, 1933, 103: 400-6.—Eismayer, G., & Quincke, H. Ueber die Energieumwandlungen des muskelkraftigen und muskel- schwachen Herzens. Klin. Wschr, 1929,8:1853.—Fischer, E. Phe heat liberated by the beating heart. Proc. R. Soc, Lond, 1926-27, ser. B, 99: 326-39.—Gemmill, C. L. The heat liberated by the beating heart; the heat produced by the terrapin s auricle with a note on the metabolism during tonus. Am. J. Physiol, 1927, 80: 668-80.—Greme's, H. Zur Physio- logie und Pharmakologie der Energetik des Saugetierher'zens. Arch. exp. Path, Berl, 1932-33, 169: 689-723. ----- Leber die Steuerung der energetischen Vorgange am Saugetier- herzen. Ibid, 1936, 182: 1-54.—Nemoto, A. Die Energieum- wandlungen im Herzmuskel; fiber den Energievorrat des Herzens und seine Verwertung. Zschr. Biol, 1927-28, 87: 498-510.—Peters, H. C, Rea, C. E, & Visscher, M. B. In- fluence of calcium ions upon energy metabolism of the mam- malian heart. Proc. Soc. Exp. Biol, N. Y., 1934, 32: 268-71.— Synder, C. D. The heat liberated by the beating heart; the tliermocardiogram of Limulus polvphemus. Am. J. Physiol., 1926 76: 170-7.------ The heat liberated by the beating neart; a study of the systoUc and diastolic temperature rises during_anoxybiosis. Ibid, 1928, 84: 69-89. ------ A new method of analyzing waves of heat production; also a study of variability of heat production, associated directly with the contractde act. Ibid, 1934, 107: 551-67.—Tanaka, H. Bei- HEART MUSCLE 337 HEART MUSCLE trace zur Thermodynamik des Herzens. J. Biophys, Tokyo, 1923-26. 1: 35; 55.—Weizsacker, V. von. Stoffwechsel und Warmebildung des Herzens. In Handb. norm. path. Physiol. (A. Bethe & G. Bergman) Berl, 1926, 7: T. 1, 689-711. --- Metabolism: Variation. Clark, A. J, Gaddie, R, & Stewart, G. P. The influence of oxvgen pressure on the metabolism of the isolated cold-blooded heart. J. Physiol, Lond, 1933, 77: 432-46— Cohn, A. E, & Steele, J. M. The metabolism of the isolated heart of dogs related to age. J. Clin. Invest, 1935, 14: 915-22.—Crismer, R. Contribution k l'etude de Taction des acides amines sur le metabolisme du myocarde. Arch, internat. physiol, Liege, 1936, 13: 1-22.—Gremels, H. Ueber die Stoffwechselwirkung von Vdivnaliu und Svmpatol am Warmbluterherzen. Arch exp. Path, Berl, 1936, 181: 165.—Herrmann, G, Decherd, G, & Oliver, T. Creatine changes in heart muscle under various clinical conditions. Am. Heart J, 1936,12:689-97.—Ichteiman, I. M. [Tissue metabolism of the cardiac muscle in normal con- ditions and during vital staining with trypan-blue] J. med, Kiev, 1937, 7: 125-30.—Konig, W. Herzarbeit ohne Sauer- stoff; die jahreszeitlichen Schwankungen der Stoffweehsel- vorgiinge im Froschherzen. Arch. exp. Path, Lpz, 1927, 12G: 129-34.—MacKay, E. M, & Barnes, R. H. Influence of amino acids and of protein diet upon creatine content of the myo- cardium. Proc. Soc. Exp. Biol, N. V, 1934-35, 32: 1562 — Mononobe, K. Untersuchungen fiber den Stoffwechsel des Herzens; die jahreszeitlichen Schwankungen der verschiedenen Phosphatmengen im Herz— und Skelettmuskel der Kroten. Fol. pharm. jap, 1930, 10: 29-38.—Victor, J. The effects of sugar and electrolyte solutions on the metaboUsm and irri- tability of heart muscle. Am. J. Physiol, 1933, 103: 620-30. --- Mycosis. Baker, R. D, & Brain, E. W. Blastomycos-s of the heart. Am. J. Path, 1937, 13: 139-47, pl— Kasper, J. A, & Pinner, M. Actinomj'cosis of the heart; report of a case with actinomycotic emboU. Arch. Path, Chic, 1930, 10: 687-96. Also repr. --- Myocarditis. Martinez, G. N., Sonzixi Astudillo, S., & Deza Genget, D. Las miocarditis. 194p. 23cm. B. Aires, 1937. Carr, J. G. Myocarditis. Illinois M. J, 1933, 64: 201-4.— Chamberlain, E. C. Isolated mvocarditis. J. Florida M. Ass, 1940-41, 27: 137-9.— Chiari, H. Ueber Myokarditis. Wien. klin. Wschr, 1933, 46: 1137-40.—Ciofli, E. Miocarditi e miocardie. Morgagni, 1929, 71: 1599-620.—Clare, W. P. Myocarditis. Med. Progr,Louisv, 1926, 42: 276-9.—Clawson, B. J. Mvocarditis. Am. Heart J, 1928-29, 4: 1-15.—Fergu- son, B. A case of myocarditis. Med. J. & Rec, 1929, 129: 637.—Januszkiewicz, A. [Achievements in the pathology and symptomatologv of myocarditis in Polish medicine] Nowiny lek, 1939, 51: 10-5.—Lange, C. de [Mvocarditis] Ned. tschr. geneesk, 1932, 76: 134-40.—Mogilnilnitsky, B. N. [On myo- carditis] Tr. Conf. insuff. circ. (1936) Kiev, 1938, 73-84.— Peel, A. A. F. Mvocarditis. Tr. R. Med. Chir. Soc. Glasgow, 1933, 27: 186-9.—Schoen. R. Ueber die Herzmuskelentzfin- dung. Jahrkurs. arztl Fortbild, 1941, 32: H. 2, 1-16 — Sutton, L. P. Carditis in children. Health Exam, N. Y, 1935, 5: No. 3, 5-18. --- Myocarditis, acute. Bailey, F. R, & Andersen, D. H. Acute interstitial myo- carditis. Am. Heart J, 1930-31, 6: 338-48.—Birile, C. Mio- carditi acute mortali di natura colibaciUare nei giovani vitelli. Gior. batt. immun, 1935, 15: 583-609.—Bessem, N, & Elsbach. E. M. [Isolated acute interstitial myocarditis as cause of sudden death] Geneesk. tschr. Ned. Indie, 1931, 71: 1045-53, 2 pl.—Botteri, I. H. [Acute myocarditisj Lijec. vjes, 1940, 62: 88.—Carr, J. G, & Walsh, J. A. Acute infectious myocarditis. Illinois M. J, 1934, 65: 134-40.—Chapelle, C. E. de la, & Graef, I. Acute isolated myocarditis with report of a case. Arch. Int. M, 1931, 47: 942-56. Also repr—Freundlich, J. Zur Kenntnis der akuten infektiosen Myokarditis. Klin. Wschr, 1930, 9: 115-7.—Frey, W. Die Therapie der akuten Myokarditis. In Bain. & Balneother. Karlsbad (1933) 1935, 14: 202-13.—Glushchenko, V. T. [On isolated acute myocar- ditis] Tr. Vseross. Konf. patologov (1934) 1935, Moskva, 167-74.—Greenebaum, J. V, Felson, W, & Zeligs, M. Acute interstitial myocarditis in an infant; report of a case with autopsy findings. J. Pediat, S. Louis, 1941, 18: 799-804 — Hansmann, G. H, & Schenken, J. R. Acute isolated myocar- ditis; report of a case, with a study of the development of the lesion. Am. Heart J, 1938, 15: 749-56.—Helwig, F. C, & Wilhelmy, E. W. Sudden and unexpected death from acute interstitial myocarditis; a report of 3 cases. Ann. Int. M, 1939-40, 13: 107-14.—Kjaergaard, H. Acute Myocarditis. Acta med. scand, 1936, Suppl 78, 151-73. Also Ugeskr. lager, 1936, 98: 732-9.—Lukomsky, P. E. [Electrocardio- graphic observations in cases of acute myocarditis] Klin, med, Moskva, 1929, 7: 1616-26.—Maxwell, E. S, & Barrett, C. C. Acute interstitial myocarditis; report of a case following a severe dermatitis due to sulphur ointment. Arch. Derm. Syph, Chic, 1934, 29: 382-6.—Mortensen, V. Significance of pre- cordial leads in electrocardiography in acute myocarditis. uiQ7 ST1*,?,0™'1' P37' 93: 35°-8- Als0 Hospitalstidende, 1J37, 80: 617-23.—Pastel, L. [On acute myocarditis] Polska gaz. lek 1939 18: 610.-Polak Daniels, L. [Case of acute myocarditis] Ned. tschr. geneesk, 1929, 73: 4-10, 2 pl— Porta), fils. Cardite aigue; observee sur un cheval. ' J. med. vet, Lyon 1849, 5: 423-5.—Quincke, H. Elektrokardio- graphische Beobachtungen bei akuter Myokarditis. Deut med. Wschr, 1933, 5!): 1629-32.—Scott, R. W, & Saphir, O. Acute isolated myocarditis. Am. Heart J, 1929-30. 5: 129- 41.—Scott. R. W, & Simon, M. A. Acute isolated (Fiedler's) myocarditis. Tr. Ass. Am. Physicians, 1936, 51: 374-80.— Serra, A. Sulle miocarditi con speciale riguardo alia forma interstiziale acuta nei cane (studio anatomo-patologico) Clin vet, Milano, 1027, 50: 2-25, 2 pl—Takane, K. Pathobio- genese der Myocardii is acuta durch organische und anorganische Jodbindungen bczichungswuise der Basedowmyokarditis. Virchows Arch, 1926, 259: 1-8.—Zamanskaia, S. A. [Diag- nosis of acute myocarditis] Klin, med, Moskva, 1939, 17: No. 5, 70-3. ---- Myocarditis, chronic. See subheading Sclerosis. ---- Myocarditis: Clinical aspect. Gomez Gonzalez, C. F. Las miocarditis; concepto clinico actual. Vida nueva, Habana, 1938, 41: 346-60.—Lohr, H. Die Klinik der Myo- und Endocarditis unter den Gesichts- punkten der fokalen Infektion. Nauheim. Fortbild. Lehrg, 1937, 13: 38-50.—Lucca, A, & Manca, C. Contributo alio studio clinico e anatomo-patologico delle miocarditi nella prima infanzia. Pediat. med. prat. Tor, 1931, 6: 135-59.—Mittel- bach, M. Zur Kenntnis der Myokarditis. Med. Klin, Berl, 1935, 31: 851-3.—Pezzi, C. La clinica delle miocarditi. Med. ital, 1931, 12: 85-92.—Smith. F. M, & Stephens, R. L. Acute, subacute and chronic interstitial mvocarditis; report of 6 cases. Tr. Ass. Am. Physicians, 1938, 53: 120-8.— Zimmermann- Meinzingen. O. von. Leber Klinik und Haufigkeit der Myo- karditis. Wien. klin. Wschr, 1940, 53: 763-8. ---- Myocarditis: Diagnosis. Baillou. Diagnostic et pronostic des etats myocardiques latents et confirmes par 1'eiectrocardiographie. Union med. nordest, 1933, 56: 11. Bordet, E. Radiologic "desimyocar- dites. Prat. mid. fr, 1927, 6: (A) 23.—Flaum, E, & Nagl. F. Elektrokardiographische Befunde bei Myocarditis. Mitt. Ges. inn. Med. Wien, 1934, 33: 03-6.—Ilie, D. [Kiirten's reaction in myocarditis lenta] Cluj. med, 1935, 16: 188.—Rossi, A, & Chini, V. Appunti di elettrocardiologia; ultenori osservazioni sulle miocarditi. Cuore & circol, 1927, 11: 71; 157.—Schick, L, & Stern, B. [Configuration of cardio-vascular shadow in myo- carditis] Vest, rentg, 1927, 5: 279-88. ---- Myocarditis: Etiology. See also under names of primary diseases as Arteriosclerosis; Diphtheria; Thyrotoxicosis, &c. Garbies, R. *De la myocardite subaigue des jeunes adultes [Lyon] 85p. 8? Bourg, 1935. Vischer, M. *Beitrage zur Myokarditis im Kindesalter besonders zur isolierten akuten Myokarditis und zur Frage der Myokarditis bei Status thymolymphaticus [Zurich] 88p. 8°. Berl., 1924. Wuhrmann, F. *Die akute Myokarditis; klinische und pathologisch-anatomische Beob- achtungen bei 36 Krankheitsfallen in ihren Beziehungen zu Herd-Infekten, zu Allgemein- Infekten (Grippe) und zur Tuberkulose [Zurich] 148p. 24cm. Basel, 1939. Ariev, M. J. IRheumatic and typhoid myocarditis] Sovet. vrach gaz, 1934, 38: 510-5. ------■ [Heart and infection] Klin, med, Moskva, 1938, 16: 581-95.—Biker, B. M, Bedell, C, & Penick, R. M, jr. Experimental carditis; changes in the myocardium and pericardium of rabbits sensitized to strep- tococci. J. Clin. Invest, 1935, 14: 465-73.—Bickel, G. Myo- cardites par carence. Rev. med. Suisse rom, 1940, 60: 124.— Bouchut, L, Levrat, M. [et al] Les complications cardiaques des cirrhoses pigmentaiics; myocardite pigmentaire? J. med. Lyon, 1935, 16: 611-20, pl—Carr, J. G. Caidiac disease in acute'infections. Mississippi Doctor, 1940-41, 18: 608-17.— Cecchini, A. Su la miocardite aftosa. Clin, vet, Milano, 1927, 50: 144-59, 2 pl.—Chaika, E. I. [Certain modifications of the interstitial tissue of the myocardium in some infectious toxic states] Radianska mei, 1939, 4: No. 10, 31-5.—Duvernay & Gerbay. Enterococcie; myocardite; mort. Lyon med, 1929, 143: 636-8.—Ederer, L, & Zarday, I. [Sensitiveness of the child's myocardium to infection] Orv. hetil, 1938 82: 822- 5__Feldmann R. Myokarditis und EndokarditisimS uighngs- aiter. Jahrb. Kinderh, 1937, 3. F, 100: 133-56 —French, A. J , & Weller, C. V. Interstitial myocarditis foUowing the clini- cal and experimental use of sulfonamide drugs. Am J. Path, 1942 18: 109-21, 2 pl.—Hanns, A, & Warter, J. Myocardite 227475—VOL. 7, 4th series- -22 HEART MUSCLE 33 etylique. Arch. mal. ccrur, 1933, 26: 391-4.—Jonas, A. F, jr. Granulomatous mvocarditis. Bull Johns Hopkins Hosp, 1939, 64: 45-65, 2 pl. Also Pract. I.ibr. M. & S, 1940, Suppl,333- 5.- bugler, G. Beitrag zur Lehre von der Myokarditis. Zbl. al'rr. Path, 1929, 45: 33-8.—I.owman, J. H. Myocarditis in acute infectious diseases. Cleveland M. J, 1906, 5: 347-52.— Mi-rhold, K. Herzmuskelschaden oder angeborene Anomalie'.' Biitiag zur Frage der tonsillogenen Myocarditis. Wien. klin. Wschr, 1939, 52: 7-9. Magner, I). A case of fatal subacute mvocarditis of unknown etiology. Am. J. M. Sc, 1939, 198: 246 52 pl— Magrini, V, A: I uchen, F. Miocarditis cripto gciKtic'a. Rev. As. med. argent, 1941, 55: 242.—Masdow, H. L, A- l.ederer, M. Interstitial mvocarditis in a child 19 months of age. Am. J. Dis. Child, 1933, 45: 807-14.- Miller, J. Granulomatous nm carditis. Canad. M. Ass. J, 1933, 29: 134-7.—Routier, 1). La m\ ocardite senile. J. med. chir. Par, 1934 10T>: 705-13.—Saplir, O. Meningococcus myocarditis. Am. J. Path, 1936, 12: 677-87, pl—Scherf, I). Myocarditis following acute tonsillitis. Bull. N. York M. Coll, 1940, 3: 252-60.— Schultz, M. P. The induction of carditis by the combined effects of hyperthyroidism and infection. Pub. Health Rep, Wash, 1939, 54: 1205-28, 10 pl—Sikl, H. Eosinophile Mvokarditis als idiosynkrasisch-allergische Er- krankung. Frankf. Zschr. Path, 1935-36, 49: 283-321.— Steiner, M, & Bogin, M. Idiopathic cardiac enlargement associated with status th\ nicoh mphaticus. Am. J. Dis Child, 1930, 39: 1255 r.n.—Taussig. H. B, it Oppenheimer, E. H Severe myocarditis of unknown etiology. Bull. Johns Hopkins Hosp, 1936, 59: 155-70.- Thomson, D, & Thomson, R. An historical survey of researches on the role of the strep- tococci in carditis. Ann. Pickett Thomson Res. Lab, Lond, 19^7-28 4: 131-250.—Tidow, G. Herz und banaler Infekt Med. Flin, Berl, 1938, 34: 1383.—Viola Rae, M. Epizootic strej toccic myocarditis in guinea pigs. J. Infect. Dis, 1936, 5!»: 236-43.— W erckn eister-Freurd, R. Myokarditis, wahr- scheinlich infolge von Grippe; zugleich ein Beitrag zur Frage der korpcrlichen I eberanstrcngung durch Sport. Zbl. allg. Path, 1931-32, 53:417-21. ---- Myocarditis, experimental. Barks-dale, E. H. The eflect of lowering blood pressure on myocarditis caused by epinephrine hydrochloride and caffeine in the labbit. Arch. Path, Chic, 1927, 3: 658-60- t herno- gdrov, 1. A. Zur Frage des Einfiusses der Netzuetlveran- deiuii'-en bei experimenteller Myokardschadigum; auf da* Lleltiokar.liocrannn. Zschr. tres. exp. Med, 1931, 76: 329- 51. (.ruber. < . M., Olch, I. V, & Blades, B. Myocarditis produced cxperimentalh in rabbits by drugs. J. Pharm. Exp. Ther 1933, 4b: 3m;-is.— Johnson. S, & Siebert, W. J. Ex- perimental nnocanhtis. Am. Heart J, 1927-28, 3: 279-86. ------ Experimental myocai dit ic lesions in the rabbit, their cited on myocardial al -ce»0 fiom intravenous injection of staphylococci. Arch. 1 ath, (. hie, 1928, 6: 54-66.—Itadnai, P, 2: 46-66.—Clerc, A, Gauthier-V illtrs, P. [et al] Sur un cas de myocardite m lanoide. Arch. mal. caur, 1940, 33: 9-17.— t osta, B. da. I m caso de pancai ■ lite. Fol. med, Rio, 1926, 7: 257.—Denis. Ln cas de myoiardite h\ pertrophiante. Rev. vet. mil. Par, 1939, 23: 185-7.—Kppingcr, H. Leber die serbse Myokarditis. Wien. klin. Wschr, 1937, 50: 709-11.— lies-ingir. N. la fragirite du syndrome anatomo-clinique des m\ ocai'lite- ei les causes de l'iiisuiiisance cardiaque dite primitive. Rev. gin. clin. ther, 1926, 40: 150-2.—Fox, I. R., & HEART MUSCLE Ovorstrect, R. M. Isolated myocarditis; report of case. North- west M . 1041, 40: 89-91.—Freundlich, J. Leber isolieite, diffuse, interstilielle Myokarditis. Zschr. lliu. Med, 1937 .IS, 133: 70S-79.- Grieshammer, W. Produktive interstilielle Mvokarditis mit Beteiligung der Pulmonalklappe. Frankf. Zschr. Path, 1939, 53: 50S-16.—Hirayama, J. Ein Fall von diffuser spezifischer Mvocarditis mit zahlreichen Riesonzellen. Tr. Soc. path, jap, 1939, 29: 261-5, pl.—Horn, F. Ueber die entzundlichen Erkrankungen des Herzens und ihre 1 nlrr- zustande. Med. Welt, 1933, 7: 589-91. Iclitcinmn. I. M. [Tissue metabolism during various -tages of iiiflaninialion and regeneration (cicatrization) of the m\ oeanliuui. fol low im; liga- ture of the anterior, descending branch of the left coronary ar- tery! J. md, Kiev, 1937, 7: 423-47, I pl Keith, T. N. Carditis; its nature and cause. Postgrad. M. J, Lond, 19:16, 12: 113-5.—Kenny, F. E, it Sanes, S. Dilatation and hyper- trophy of the heart in infancy due to paieuehimatous mvo- carditis. J. Pediat, S. Louis, 1933, 3: 321-9.—Krylov, I). O. [Angiocarditis] Tr. Acad, mil med. Kiioif, 193 1, 1: 16 58.— Legrand, R, & Nayrac, P. Un cas de myocardite intcrstitielle diffuse isolee avec rupture du coeur. Echo med. nord, 1935, 3. ser, 3: 590-602.—Liebmann, E. Untersuchungen Uber die Herzmuskulatur bei Infektionskrankheiten; zur Frage der eosinophilic Myokarditis. Deut. Arch. klin. Med, 1915, 117: 438—17, pl—Lopez Ramirez, R, & Israel, J. E. Variacipnes de la actividad auricular en una miocarditis. Prensa med. argent, 1936, 23: 2513-7.—McGrath, R. Interstitial myocarditis, lupus erythematosus type; acute arteritis, periadrenal, lupus erythematosus type; periarterial fibrosis of spleen; lobular pneumonia, bilateral. N. York State J. M, 1941, 41: 2248- 50.— Mentova, V. N. [Reaction of coronary yessals and heart to vascular poisons in experimental myocarditis; production of myocarditis; effect of substances with general cellular action on il,.- coronaiy vesseM Farm. & toks, Moskva, 1939, 2: No. 5, 5 1-9. Rapoport, J. I, (Myocarditis, myocardiodystrophy and cjinlioscleiosis from the view-point of experimental morphology (with discussions)] Klin, med, Moskva, 1940, 18: No. 9, 23-42. Saphir, O. Mvocarditis; a general review, with an analysis of 240 cases. Arch. Path, Chic, 1941, 32: 1000; passim.—Sikl, H. Die Myokarditis vom pathologiseh-ana- tomischen Standpunkte. In Bain. & Balneother, Karlsbad (1935) 1936, 15: 406-32.—Simon, M. A, & Wolpaw, S. Acute, subacute and chronic isolated myocarditis; report of a case. Arch. Int. M, 1935, 56: 1136-12.Supino, I, Di alcuni reperti anatomici rari del cuore. Med. ital, 1933, 14: 259- 94.—Vannotti, A, & Singeisen, F. I lie ('apillarisierimg und die Erniihrung des Herzens und der grossen (ief. sse unter normalen und pathologischen Bedingungen; die ( api lardurchblutung des Herzmuskels bei der Myocard is diphtheriea. Zschr. ges. exp. Med, 1936, 99: 387-93.—Wassermeyer, H, & Rohrbach, A. Leber chemische und kolloidchemische Prozesse im Herz- muskel bei experimenteller Myokarditis. Arch. exp. Path, Berl, 1932, 166: 375-91. ---- Myocarditis, rheumatic. See Heart rheumatism. ---- Myocarditis, traumatic. See also Heart, Injury. Proeger, K. *Die Geschichte der Sympto- matologie der Pericarditis und Carditis trau- matica der Rinder [Leipzig] 7p. 8? Dresd., 1920. Cavagliano, B. Miocardite di origine traumatica con attac- chi anginoidi in persona giovane. Med. lavore, 1931, 22: 315- 51.—Cler, G. O. Miocarditis traumatica en un canino. Rev. med. vet, B. Air, 1940, 22: 553-8. ---- Myocarditis: Treatment. Austrian, C. R. Treatment of acute inflammation of the heart. Med. Clin. N. America, 1935, 18: 1515-32.—Bantin, E. IChanges in respiration, pulse, blood pressure, and dimensions of the heart in myocarditis treated bv hot mud and salt-water baths] Klin, med, Moskva, 1927, 5: 1229-34.—Demers, G. A nursing study of myocarditis. Canad. Nurse, 1941, 37: 635.— Dubinin, F. G. [Effect of strophantin on the course of the elec- trocardiograminexperimentalmyocarditis in rabbits] Farm. & toks, Moskva, 1941, 4: No. 2, 43-9.—Egorov, B. A. [Roentgen therapy in endo-and myocarditis] Sovet. vrach. gaz, 1934, 18: 267-70.—Frey, W. Die Therapie der Mvokarditis. Zschr. arztl. Fortbild, 1934, 31: 493-6.—Jegorov, B. La radiotherapie des endocardites et myocardites. Progr. med. Par, 193-1, 1337. Also Strahlentherapie, 1935, 52: 97-100.—Maestrini, I). L'azione dell'estratto del nodo di Keith e Flack in miocarditici. Riforma med, 1928, 44: 1662.—Sokolova, L. N. [Action of caffein, camphor and corazol on the cardio-vascular system of the rabbits in experimental myocarditis] Farm. & toks, Moskva, 1911, 4: No. 2, 34-42.—Stephan, K. Biologische Behandlung eines schweren Falles von Herzinsuffizienz (Myo- carditis; Hippokrates, Stuttg, 1935, 6: 391-7.—Stepukhovich, D. Ai., Blank, N. G., & Nuzarenko, M. I. [Efficacy of Narzan baths in Kislovodsk in treatment of children with post-inflam- matoyr changes of the cardiac muscle] Pediatria, Moskva, 1940, No. 9, 29.—Toogood, E. S. Scarlet fever antitoxin in a case of endocarditis and myocarditis. Lancet, Lond, 1926, 2: 545. HEART MUSCLE 339 HEART MUSCLE ---- Myomalacia [and necrosis] See also Coronary artery, Thrombosis; also other subheadings of Heart muscle (Abscess; Infarction; Ischaemia; Rupture) Rintelen, F. *Zur Kenntnis des myomala- cischen Septumdefektes und zur Spontanruptur des Herzens [Basel] 17p. 8? Dresd., 1933. Bosworth, T. J. Multiple necrotic lesions in the heart of a cow. Vet. Rec, Lond, 1929, 9: 696.—Ch'in, K. Y, & Huang, C. H. Myocardial necrosis in diphtheria; with a general review of the lesions of the myocardium in diphtheria. Am. Heart J, 1941 22: 690-701.—Froboese, C. Erschopfungsnekrosen des Herzmuskels. Beitr. path. Anat, 1935, 95: 496.—Hauss, W, & Yamanaka, T. Leber einige Blutveriinderungen bei Nekrosen im Herzmuskel und im quergestreiften Muskel Zschr. klin. Med, 1938, 134: 604-13.—Lampert, F., & Damir, A. Experi- menteller Beitrag zur Desympathisation des (muskelkranken) myomalacischen Herzens. Arch. klin. Chir, 1931, 165: 532- 8. Also Sovet. khir, 1931, 1: 399.—Laubry, C, Soulie, P, & Mathivat, A. Faux anevrysme parietal du cceur par myo- malacie de 1'infundibulum pulmonaire. Arch. mal. coeur, 1938, 31: 1119-26.—McJunkin, F. A, Tweedy, W. R., & Mencky, W. J. Necrosis of the myocardium induced by the orthophosphates. Arch. Path, Chic, 1934, 18: 626-34.—Melnick. Ancient myomalacia of the left ventricle of the heart. In Path. Conf. (Jaffe, R. H.) Chic, 1940, 947-9. ------ & Jaffe, R. H. Ancient myomalacia of the left ventricle of the heart. Bull Chicago M. Soc, 1935, 38: 7.—Neiman, B. Myomalacia of the heart with perforation of the left ventricle into the right ventricle. In Path. Conf. (Jaffe, R. H.) Chic, 1940, 994.— Observation de ramollissement du coeur. J. med. Toulouse, 1864, 4. ser, 3: 138-41.—Plaut, A, & Kramer, M. L. Arteriolar disease of the heart associated with severe myomalacia; coronary arteries intact. Arch. Path, Chic, 1936, 22: 393-7.—Pretts, W. M. Myomalacia cordis, with report of a case. U. S. Veterans Bur. M. Bull, 1930, 6: 679-83.—Renfern, E. Dos casos de necrosis del corazon por radium. Bol. Liga cancer, Habana, 1928, 4: 116.—Rogers, H. Necrosis of the myo- cardium. Bristol Med. Chir. J, 1931, 48: 35-40, pl. ---- Ossification. See under subheading Calcification. ---- Papillary muscle. See also subheading Chordae tendineae. Eucker, H. *Untersuchungen iiber die Form und das Verhalten des linken hinteren Papillar- muskels des menschlichen Herzens. 28p. 8? Gott., 1935. Chu, H. P. Are the papillary muscles more rhythmical than other parts of the ventricle? Chin.. J. Physiol, 1929, 3: 223- 8.—Schultze, W. H. Leber die Formverschiedenheiten der Papillarmuskeln des linken Herzens. Verh. Deut. path. Ges, 1935, 28: 245-50.—Wolff, K. Die Langs- und Spiralanordnung der Muskulatur in der Media der Papillarmuskelschlagadern. Virchows Arch, 1930, 276: 259-78. ---- Papillary muscle: Avulsion, and rupture. Diestelhorst, H. H. *Ein Fall von Spontan- ruptur eines Papillarmuskels [Leipzig] 16p. 8? [Zeulenroda] 1929. Voigt, W. *Spontanruptur eines Papillar- muskels, zugleich ein Beitrag zur Gestalt des linken hinteren Papillarmuskels [Kiel] 29p. 8°. Dresd 1932 Also Zschr. Kreislaufforsch, 1932, 24: 667-93. Wixgler, F. *Ueber einen Fall von Zerreis- sung des hinteren Papillarmuskels der Mitralis. 31p. 8? Lpz., 1927. Burn, C. G. Spontaneous nontraumatic rupture of pos- terior papillary muscle of the heart. N. York State J. M, 1941, 41: 1254.—Hausen-Faure, G, & Hasenjager, E. Zwei Falle von Papillarmuskelruptur. Klin. Wschr, 1938, 17: 540-2.—Klein, F. [Spontaneous rupture of the papillary muscle] Bratisl. lek. listy, 1929, 9: 776-84.—Lipscomb, H. R. Rupture of a papillary muscle in the heart. Med. Bull. Veter- ans Admin, 1938-39, 15: 73.—Lowry, F. C, & Burn, C. G. Spontaneous rupture of the posterior papillary muscle of the heart. Arch. Path, Chic, 1941, 31: 382-5.—Moragues, V. Spontaneous rupture of a papillary muscle of the heart; report of case. Am. Heart J, 1939, 17: 106-10.—Payne, W. C, & Hardy, H. H, jr. Traumatic rupture of the papillary muscles of the mitral valves; a case report. N. Orleans M. & S. J, 1936-37, 89: 373-5.—Power, F. K. Healing spontaneous rupture of the posterior mitral papillary muscle. Tr. Chicago Path. Soc, 1923-26, 12: 282-6. Also repr.—Stevenson, R. R, & Turner, W. J. Rupture of a papillary muscle in the heart as a cause of sudden death. BuU. Johns Hopkins Hosp, 1935 57: 235-42— Wagner, H. Beitrag zur spontanen Papillarmuskelruptur. Frankf. Zschr. Path, 1929, 37: 293- ---- Papillary muscle: Disease, and abnormity. Collins, D. C. Anomalous papillary muscle attached to pulmonary valve of heart. Am. Heart J, 1931, 7: 79-83.— Pana, C. Malformazione ed inserzione anomala del muscolo papillare anteriore sulla valvola mitrale. Monit. zool. ital, 1934, 45: 40-8.—Severi, L. Frequenza e distribuzione dell'ar- teriosclerosi nei muscoli papillari delle valvole venose del cuore Diagnosi, 1936, 16: 59-75.—Stoeckenius, W. Ueber ein Blutknotchen an einem Warzenmuskel des rechten Herzens Zbl. allg. Path, 1926, 38: 67-72.—Yater, W. M. Abnormally long papillary muscles of the human heart. Am. Heart J 1928-29,4:72-8. ---- Parasites. See also subheadings (Echinococcosis; Mycosis) also Sarcosporidium. Langen, C. D. de [Parasitic affection of the cardiac muscle] Geneesk. tschr. Ned. Indie, 1938, 78: 680-2.—VonGlahn, \V. C. Unidentified parasite in heart muscle. Am. J. Path, 1934, 10: 647-9, 4 pl. ---- Permeability, and absorptive power. Cicardo, V. H, & Marenzi, A. D. Changements d'excita- bilite et permeabilite du coeur de crapaud aux ions potassium, sodium et calcium. C. rend. Soc. biol, 1938, 129: 855-7. Also Rev. Soc. argent, biol, 1938, 14: 59-73.—Cornil, L, Jouve, A. X, & Haimovici. Sur l'absorption parietale des substances injectees dans les cavites cardiaques. Arch. mal. coeur, 1939, 32: 213.—Jullien. A, & Peillon, M. De la per- meabilite du coeur d'Helix pomatia au chlorine de calcium. C. rend. Soc. biol, 1937, 124: II13.—Matera, A. Azione ed assorbimento del glucosio nei cuore di rana. Clin. med. ital, 1934, 65: 1186-91.—Ort, J. M, Power, M. H, & Markowitz, J. Studies in cardiac permeability. Am. J. Physiol, 1931, 98: 163-8.—Orzechowski, G. Zur Ionenpermeabilitat des iso- lierten Froschherzens. Arch. exp. Path, Berl, 1936, 183: 77-86.—Robertson, J, & Clark, A. J. The uptake of ethyl alcohol by the isolated tortoise's heart. Biochem. J, Lond, 1933, 27: 83-5.—Smith, H. W. The action of acids on turtle heart muscle with reference to the penetration of anions. Am. J. Physiol, 1926, 76: 411-47.—Titaev, A. A, & Shakh- Nazarian, T. S. Permeabilite du muscle cardiaque; l'influence des facteurs exogenes. Bull. biol. med. exp. URSS, 1936, 1: 155; 157.—Wassermeyer, H. Ueber ionale Einwirkungen auf die Alterung in Pressaften von Herzen. Zschr. physiol. Chem, 1931, 203: 241-54.—Wiggers, C. J. The absorption of drugs from the right ventricular cavity. J. Pharm. Exp. Ther, 1930, 39: 209-19. ---- Pharmacology. See also under proper and group names of drugs as Anesthesia; Cardiotonics; Digitalis, &c. Hartmann, W. *Die Wirkung der Adenosin- phosphorsaure im Elektrokardiogramm. p.424- 46. 8? Berl., 1932. Also Zschr. klin. Med, 1932, 121: Mayer, E. *Der Einfluss von Digitalis und Strophautin im Elektrokardiogramm des Rindes mit Untersuchungen zur Klarung der Natur der darin auftretenden Strecke h. 47p. 21cm. Miinch., 1938. Agnoli, R, & Bussa. D. Azione cardiaca dell'ormone folli- colare e luteinico. Boll. Soc. ital. biol. sper, 1939, 14: 99.— Akita, T. Beitrage zur Wirkung des Adrenalins auf das Herz. Jap. J. M. Sc, 1937, 10: Proc. Pharm, 1.—Arvanitaki, A, & Blanc, H. Action des ions H et des ions OH sur la survie, la rythmicite, le tonus, le potentiel d'activite du myocarde de l'escargot. J. physiol. path, gen, 1934, 32: 775-91.—Arvani- taki, A, & Cardot, H. Action du magnesium sur l'excitabilite du mvocarde ventriculaire de l'escargot et de la grenouille. C. rerid. Soc. biol, 1931, 106: 1024-6.—Bacq, Z. M. Absence de reactions du cceur d'une ascidie (Ciona intestinalis) k I'adrenaline, k ['acetylcholine et aux ions K, Ca et Ba. Ibid, 1934, 117: 486.—Baron, B. The electrocardiogram after application of local anaesthetics on the cardiac surface. Bull. N. York M. Coll, 1940, 2: 121-35.—Barry, D. T, Chauchard, A. [et al] Variations de la p6riode tefractaire et de la chronaxie du myocarde chez les poissons sous l'influence de substances agissant sur le systeme nerveux autonome. C. rend. Soc. biol, 1939, 132: 216^9.—Borggraef, L. de. Influence du chlore, du b'rome et de l'iode sur l'excitabilite du cceur de grenouille. Ibid, 1929, 101: 167.—Calhoun, J. A, Cullen, G. E. [et al] Studies in congestive heart failure; the effect of the administra- tion of dibasic potassium phosphate on the potassium content of certain tissues. J. Clin. Invest, 1930-31, 9: 693-703 — Claes, E. Action de l'extrait surtenal et de 1'adtenaUne sur le coeur isoie du lapin. Arch, internat. physiol, Liege, 1923-24, 22: 322-44.—Colle, J. L'influence du potassium sur l'excita- HEART MUSCLE 340 HEART MUSCLE bilite du corur de grenouille. C. rend. Soc. biol, 1926, 94: 1257-9. ------ L'influence du chlorure de sodium sui l'excita- bilite du cceur de grenouille.. Ibid, 1927, 96: 1065-7.— Delorenzi. E. Azione di alcuni farmaci sul miocardio coltivato in vitro. Arch. farm, sper, 1939, 67: 32-44.—Duliere, W. L'irritabilite du cceur de grenouille sous l'influence du chlorure de lithium. ( . rend. Soc. biol, 1927, 97: 1833-6.------ & Borggraef, I, de. L'irritabilite du caur isoie de la grenouille sous l'influence du chlorure de magnesium. Ibid, 1928, 98: 883-5.—Fredericq, H. Action des acides amines sur la con- tractilite, le tonus vasculaire et le metabolisme du coeur isoie du lapin. Arch, intermit, physiol, Liege, 1922-23, 20: 213- 40.—Gauer, O, & Kramer, K. Zur Frage der oxydations- steigernden Wirkuiig des Adrenalins am Warmbluterherzen. Arch. ges. Physiol, 1939. 242: 328-43.—Gellhorn, E. Experi- ments on the Hofmeister si ries in heart muscle. Protoplasma, Lpz, 1933, 18: 411-9. Gruber, C. M, & Kountz, W. B. The electrocardiogram of non-anesthetized dogs as modified bv the intravenous injection of pitressin, atropine sulphate and vagus section. J. Pharm. Exp. Ther, 1930, 39: 353-73 — Gruber. C. M, Moon, V. H, & Sufrin, E. A study of the response of the heart to pitressin following the administration of thyroid extract. Endocrinology, 1935, 19: 447-52 — Guidi. G. Azione di alcune acque minerali naturali sul cuore isolato di ( terotermi ed omeotermi. Arch. ital. sc. farm, 1935, 4: 173-217—Guiran, J. B. Effets du F. 933 sur la chronaxie et la periode tefractaire du mvocarde de la grenouille. C. rend. Soc. biol, 1939, 131: 1051-4— Hafkesbring, R, & MacCal- monl, W. The effect of sodium amytal, sodium barbital and nembutal on the electro-cardiogram. J. Pharm. Exp. Ther, 1038, 64: 43-9.—Harreveld, A. van. Ueber eine Veriinderung ties Elektrokardiogrammes des Froschherzens bei Dureh- stromung mit einer Glukose-Bikarbonat-Losung. Acta brevia neerl, 1932, 2: 165.—Heckmann, K. Pharmakologische Beeinflussung der Herztatigkeit im Kymogramm. Klin. Wschr, 1935, 14: 1700-13.--Heirman, P. Modification des actions canlia'iues cie l'adreiialine au cours de son oxydation paries pheuola-e.-. Arch, internat. phisinl.. Li6ge, 1938, 46: 404-16. Hc.fT. H. E, iv Nahum. I, H. Influence of local applications of potassium chloride on action current of the mammalian heait. Proc. Soc. Exp. Biol, N. Y, 1940, 45: 263-5.—Holz, B, & Mis>ke. B. Einfluss des AcetcssigsSure- Aethylesters auf das Aktionsstrombild des Froschherzens. Arch. exp. Path, Berl, 1934, 176: 1 99-206.—Hykes, O. V. Mouvements du coeur chez les dnplmics sous l'influence de quelques substances endocrines. ('. rend. Soc. biol, 1926, 95: 58-60.------■ L'influence de quelques substances endo- crines sur l'activite du coeur chez les invertebres. Ibid, 203-6.—Jullien, A, & Morin, G. Action de divers liquides sur le fonctionnement du ventricule isol6 chez le poulpe et la seiche. Ibid, 1930, 105: 647-50.—Kanda, Z. Leber die Reizbarkeit des Froschherzen vent nkels unter Wirkung von Azetylcholin, Cholin und Kali-alz. Arch. e\p. Path, Lpz, 1938, 190: 417-20.—Kato, S. Leber die Lmflusse der ver- schiedenen Hormone auf die Herzt itigkeit. Gun idan zasshi, 1932, No. 233, 1-0.—Katz, G. I, & Leibensohn, E. A. Action des extraits de glandes endocrines et du systeme cardiovascu- laire des animaux k sang chaud sur le cceur des animaux a sang chaud in situ. Paris med, 1929, 71: 590-3.—Kauf, E. Leber die Einwirkung von Atropin und Adrenalin auf das Herz Sporttreibender. Wien. klin. Wschr, 1926, 39: 212-4.— hirsch, R, & Fredericq, H. Recherches chronaximetriques relatives a Taction prolongee du calcium et du potassium sur l'excitabilite du caur isole de la tortue. C. rand. Soc. biol, 1930, 103: 34-6.—Kisch, B. Differenzierende Wirkun?s- analysen von Herzgiften; das Ca- und Sr-Paradoxon. Arch. exp. Path, Lpz, 1930, 148: 140-9.—Kruta, V. Leber die Beeinf ussung der Tatigkeit des isolierten Saugerherzens durch Glvkolysehemmung mittels der Monojodessigsaure. Zschr. ges. exp. Med, 1933-34, 92: 612-22.—Lanczos, A. Ueber die Wirkung des Vagusstoffes und Acetylcholine auf die isoherte Kammer des Froschherzens. Arch. ges. Phvsiol, 1930, 225: 710-20.—Lian, C, & Merklen, F. P. Alterations experi- mentales des portions moyenne et terminale du complexe ventriculaire eiectrocardiographique (injections intra-myo- cardiques de nitrate d'argent) C. rend. Soc. biol, 1931, 107: 696-8. ------ Alterations experimentales de la grande onde initiale du complexe ventriculaire eiectrocardiographique, par injections de nitrate d'argent dans la cloison interventricu laire. Ibid, 807.—Lissak, K. Effects of extracts of adrenergic fibers on the frog heart. Am. J. Physiol, 1939, 125: 778-85. ------ & Wert, F. CholinempfindUchkeit des sensibilisierten Meerschweinchenherzens. Arch. exp. Path, Berl, 1935-30, 180: 466-8.—Lolli, N. Variazioni elettrocardiografiche da derivati de molecola proteica. Diagnosi, 1934, 14: 266-91.— Lyon-Caen, L. Action de la bile et des sels biliaires sur l'ex- citabilite et la conductibilite cardiaques. C. rend. Soc. biol, 1927. 97: 216.—Malltrdo, C. A. Segni elettrocardiografici dell azione del glucosio sul miocardio. Morgagni, 1933, 73: 870 90, 2 pl.—Markowitz. C. Response of explanted embry- onic cardiac tis-ue tr, epinephrine and acetylcholine. Am. J Physiol., vxu. 97: 271-5. ------& Yater, W. M. Response of explanted caidiac muscle to thyroxine. Ibid, 1932, 100: 162-0.- Mit urrcri, T. The effect of adrenaUne on the heart of the chick embryo. Endocrinology, 1929, 13: 537-48.— Mentl, S, Kara' ek. F, & Kruta, V. Importance du cholesterol pour 1 action du calcium sur le muscle cardiaque. Arch, inter- nal, physiol, Liege, 1934-35, 40: 158-72.—Moisset de Espanes. E. Action de la quinidine et de la fagarine I sur la chronaxie du myocarde. C. rend. Soc. biol, 1937, 12G: 834-6.----- Action de la fugarine I et de la quinidine sur l'excitabilite et la capacite fibrillatoire du myocarde. Ibid, 1938, 127: 118-20.— Nemoto, A. The influence of a trace of amino-acid upon the oxvgen consumption, the value of the work done and the efficiency of the isolated heart. Sei i kwai, 1929, 48: No. 8, 14.—Newton, H. F, Zwemer, R. L, & Cannon, W. B. Studies on the conditions of activity in endocrin organs; the mystery of emotional acceleration of tho denervated heart after ex- clusion of known humoral accelerators. Am. J. Physiol, 1931 96: 377-91.—Nielsen, N. A, & Trier, M. [Comparison between changes in the electrocardiogram following strophanthin, acetylcholin, and excitation of the vagus] Hospitalstidende 1938, 81: 759-07. Also Am. Heart J, 1939, 17: 515 23.— Ordynsky, S. I. [Pharmacology of the isolated heart; sensi- bility to adrenalin of minute and systolic volumes and the absolute strength of the heart of the frog] J. Phvsiol. USSR 1937, 23: 321-8.—Petzetakis. Action de l'adrenaline oil njection intraveineuse sur le coeur du lapin; fibrillation cardi- aque terminale; etude eiectrocardiographique. C. rend. Soc. biol, 1931, 106: 885-7.—Popesco, M. L'action comparative de la digitale et du tabac sur l'excitabilite et la contractilite du muscle ventriculaire de la grenouille. Ibid, 1938, 128: 321-3.—Radnai, P. [Effect of acidification upon the myo- cardium] Orv. hetil. 1936, 80: 998. Also Zschr. Kreislaufforsch, 1937, 29: 18-23.—Riccitelli, L. Manifestazioni elettrocardio- grafiche da ormoni. Endoer. pat. cost, Bologna, 1931, !): 167-93, 22 pl—Robb, J. S, Dooley, M. S, & Robb. R. ('. Potassium chloride and pontocaine applied superficially anil injected deeply into ventricular muscle bands. Am. J. Pin siol 19-11, 133: 426.—Rothmann, H. Der Einfluss der Adciosin- phosphorsiiuro auf die Herztatigkeit. Arch. exp. Path., I.p/. 1930, 155: 129-38.—Rufimsky, W. W. Ueber Steigenmg der AdrenalinempfindHchkeit des Froschherzens nach Kreatin- und Kreatinineinwirkung. Arch. ges. Physiol, 1929-30, 223: 699-708.—Sato, M. On the action of ions and isotonic Ringer's solution on the strip of the inner and outer layers of the heart ventricle. Acta Scholae med. Univ. Kioto, I92S-29, 11: 403-23, pi—Sawyer, M. E. M, & Brown, M. G. The effect of thyroidectomy and thyroxine on the response of the de- nervated heart to injected and secreted adrenine. Am. J, Physiol, 1934-35, 110: 620-35.—Schellong, F. Untersu- chungen uber die Grundeigenschaften des Herzmuskels; die Refraktarphase der Erregungsfortpflanzung im normalen und digalenvergift.eten Herzmuskel Zschr. ges. exp. Med, 1931, 78: 1-14.—Segre, R, & Cantoni, G. Effetti sul miocardio di un intenso trattamento tiroideo. Cuore & circol, Roma, 1932, 16: 389-408.— Sherif, M. A. F. The relation between the action and concentration of ether and camphor applied to the heart muscle. J. Pharm. Exp. Ther, 1936, 56: 1-22.—Starr, I, Gamble, C. J. [et al] A clinical study of the action of 10 commonly used drugs on cardiac output, work and size; on respiration, on metabolic rate and on the electrocardiogram. J. Clin. Invest, 1937, 16: 799-823.—Staub, H., & Kuh, J. Leber den Gehalt des Herzmuskels an VagusstofT nach Herz- glykosid-Wirkung. Klin. Wschr, 1939, 18: 783.—Sterne, J, Hovet, D, & Henry, C. Action du diethylamino-ethoxy-2- diphenyle, 1262 F, sur 1'eiectrocardiogramme normal et pathologique. C. rend. Soc. biol, 1939, 130: 209-11.—Sterne, J., Bovet, D, & Lenoir, J. Effets du diethylaminomethyl- benzodioxan, 883 F, sur les lesions myocardiques provoque'es. Ibid, 207-9.—Suzuki, T. Effect of some hormone preparations on heart-musculature; some experiments on sinus-atrium preparation of toad's heart. Nagoya J. M. Sc, 1935, 8: 121; 129.—Takacs, L. Herz und innere Sekretion. Zschr. ges. exp. Med, 1927, 57: 514-26—Vesa, A. Elektrokardiogra- phische Untersuchungen uber d;e Arbeitsversuch nach Adrena- lininjektion. Acta Soc. med. Duodecim, 1938-39, 26: Ser. B, No. 11, 1-22.—Voitinsky, U. A. [Korotkov's sound mani- festations under the effect of subcutaneous and intravenous injections of adrenalin] Klin, med, Moskva, 1933, 11: 1130- 3.—Watanabe, T. Ueber den Einfluss verschiedener Pharmaka auf refrakt ire Phase des Herzmuskels. Jip. J. M. Sc, 1941, 14: Abstr. Pharm, 15.—Wedd, A. M. The influence of digoxin on the potassium content of heart muscle. J. Pharm. Exp. Th r, 1939, 65: 268-74.—Wiggers, C. J. Monophasic and deformed ventricular complexes resulting from surface applica- tions of potassium salts. Am. Heart J, 1929-30, 5: 346-50. ---- Pharmacology: Poisons. See also proper names of poisons. Schmitt, W. *Vergleichende Untersuchungen iiber die Vergiftungsgeschwindigkeit von g- Strophanthin, Scillaren und Folinerin am iiber- lebenden Herz von Rana temporaria [Erlangen] 29p. 8? Bleicherode, 1936. Sokoloff, O. *Physiologische und toxi- cologische Studien am Herzen. 35p. 8? Bern, 1881. Anichkov, S. V. [Changes in the sensitiveness to poisons 'n isolated hearts of poisoned frogs] J. teor. piakt. med, 1923, 1: 307-2 I—Cattell, J. McK. The adaptation of the heart to toxic concentrations of ether. Brit. J. Anaesth, 1927, 5: 27.—ChLrtoni, A. Etudes sur le coeur isoie de mammifere; alcool ethylique et cholesterine. Arch, internat. physiol., HEART MUSCLE 341 HEART MUSCLE Liege, 1913-14, 14: 201-20.—Dutant, J. Reprise du tonus et de l'automatisme d'un coeur epuise sous Faction de divers poisons. C. rend. Soc. biol, 1937, 126: 1130-2.—Goldenberg, M & Rothberger, C. J. Die Monojodessigs'iurevergiftung des Herzmuskels. Zschr. ges. exp. Med, 1931, 79: 687-704. ----- Die Monojodessigsaurevergiftung des Herzmuskels; Versuche am Warmbluterherzen. Ibid., 1932-33, 85: 315-68.— Kisch, B. Differenzierende Wirkungsanalysen von Herz- giften; die Wirkung von MgOh, SrCh und BaCL auf die Hsrzreizbildung beim Kaltbluter. Arch. exp. Path, Lpz, 1927 124: 210-30. ■-----■ Die Wirkung von Azetaldehyd auf das Froschherz. Ibid, 1928, 138: 329-38.—Konikov, A. L. [Effect of a strychnin altered heart on the pessimum of duration of a single stimulus] J. Physiol USSR, 1941, 30: 283-9 — Kruta, V. Action des poisons du systeme nerveux autonome sur le coeur isoie de la seiche. J. physiol. path. gen.. 1936, 34: 65-76.—Levi, M. L'elettrogramma del cuore isolato sotto l'azione del cloroformio. Boll. Soc. biol. sper, 1926, 1: 102-7.— Lutembacher, R. Action sur le coeur du venin de crapaud. Presse med, 1938, 46: 1469-71.—Marino. S. Ricerche speri- mentali riguardanti l'azione che le tossine batteriche esercitano sul cuore; contributo all'azione della tossina dissenterica sul cuore in situ di rana. Arch. farm, sper, 1934, 58: 149-74.— Meek, W. J, Hathaway, H. R, & Orth, O. S. The effects of ether, chloroform and cyclopropane on cardiac automaticity. J. Pharm. Exp. Ther, 1937, 61: 240-52.—Mezey, K., & Staub, H. Giftwirkungen am isolierten Herzkammerstreifen des Frosches; Wirkung von Alkaloiden und ihrer Stammsub- stanzen. Arch. exp. Path, Berl, 1936, 182: 183-204.— Mikhailov, K. M. [Effect of gitalin and caffeine on variability of excitation of the ventricles by faradic current] Arkh. biol nauk, 1936, 44: 77-84.—Mononobe, K. Die Superposition der Extrasystole beim isolierten Froschherzen infolge von Schadigung durch Narkotika. Nark. & Anaesth, Berl, 1928, 1: 273-83.—Ohta, K. Ueber die anatom schen Veranderungen im Herzen bei verschiedenen Intoxikationen. Tr. Jap. Path. Soc, 1924, 14: 122.—Shen, T. C. R. Influences du diethyl- amino-ethoxy-2-diphenyle, F. 1262, et de la corynanthine sur la fibrillation cardiaque adrenahno-benzolique. C. rend. Soc. biol, 1939, 132: 52-4.—Siegel, R, & Unna, Z. Ueber die Zerlegung der Aktionsstromkurve des Herzens in chemische Teilphasen; die Monojodessigsaurevergiftung des Herzens im Elektrokardiogramm. Zschr. ges. exp. Med, 1931, 78: 287- 309.—Sivertsev, I. I. [Effect of chloroform, ether, alcohol and acetone on the coronary vessels and action of the isolated human heart] Farm. & toks, Moskva, 1939, 2: No. 5, 72-80 — Stocke, A. Die Disposition des Sportherzes fiir Herzaffek- tionen durch gewerbliche Gifte. Med. Klin, Berl, 1931, 27: 1277-9.—Tanabe, T, & Ito, S. Vergleichende Untersuchungen iiber die Wirkungen des Lucidusculins und des Aconitins auf das isolierte Herz. Jap. J. M. Sc, 1938, 11: Proc. Pharm, 45.—Tsobkallo, G. I. [Correlation between surface tension of poison solutions and their effect on the heart of the frog] Arkh. biol nauk, 1934, 34: 149-56.—Werz, R. von. Kann man spezifische Gifte der Herzmuskelzelle an ihrer elektro- motorischen Wirkung erkennen? (Grundsatzliches zur Pharma- kologie des Erregungsvorgangs und zur Deutung von EG- Veranderungen) Arch. exp. Path, Berl, 1934-35, 177: 183- 203.—Wind, F. Versuche iiber Beeinflussbarkeit der Narkose des Froschherzens. Ibid, 1926, 116: 135-9. Also repr. --- Physiology. See also Heart, Physiology; Heartbeat; Heart conduction; Heart function, &c. Abramson, E. Die Riickstosskurve des Herzens (Kardio- dynamogramm) Skand. Arch. Physiol, Berl, 1933, 66: 191-224.—Bohmig, R. Morphologische Untersuchungen zur Herzmuskelfunktion. Klin. Wschr, 1935, 14: 1816-8 — Burridge, W. Some new properties of cardiac muscle, etc. Arch, internat. pharm. dyn. Par, 1939, 62: 399-410.— Chacuin, E. C, & Sorescu, A. Perfusion cardiaque et prepara- tion d'un serum antimyocardique. C. rend. Soc. biol, 1931, 106: 118-20.—Foa, C. Recenti conquiste nei campo della fisiologia del miocardio. Med. ital, 1931, 12: 211-9.—Gregg, D. E., & Eckstein, R. W. Measurements of in ramyocardial pressure. Am. J. Physiol, 1941, 132: 781-90.—Kruta, V. Variations saisonnieres des reactions du myocarde chez le cobaye. C. rend. Soc. bioL, 1936, 122: 433-5.—Pratt, F. H. Muscle and the heart's motto. Biol. Sympos, Lane, 1941, 3: 35-50— Robb, J. S., Hiss, F. J. G, & Robb, R. C. The physi- ological importance of the individual muscles in the mammalian ventricle. Proc. In'ernat. Physiol. Congr. (1935) 1938, 15. Congr, 426.—Slauck, A. Tierexperimentelle Un ersuchungen am Herzmuskel. Verh. Deut. Ges. inn. Med, 1931, 43. Kongr, 454-61.—Stienon, L. Contribution k l'etude du myocarde specifique chez les vertebres. Arch, biol. Par, 1930, 40: 57-82. ------ Sur la specialisa ion du tissu myo- cardique. Bruxelles med, 1937-38, 18: 287-93.— Tamura, O. Ueber die Spezifitat der Herzmuskulatur. Tr. Soc. path. jap, 1934, 24: 274-7.—Visscher, M. B. La aplicaci6n de la fisiologia del mdsculo cardiaco en medicina. Arch. lat. amer. card, Mex, 1941, 11: 1-9.—Weller, C. V. Biological sig- nificance of protective mechanisms inherent in the myocardium. Proc. Nat. Acad. Sc. U. S, 1933, 19: 318-20. ---- Physiology: Dynamics. Clamann, H. G. Beitrag zur Physik des Herzmuskels, Verh. Phys. med. Ges. Wurzburg, 1933, n. F., 58: 86.—Deomor. J, & Rijlant, P. Contributions k la physiologie generale du cceur; le mecanisme du travail des ventricules. Bull. Acad med. Belgique, 1926, 5. ser, 6: 553-73, 10 pl. Also Arch' internat. physiol, Liege, 1926, 27: 397-424.—Fox, F. T. Root pounds of work of heart. J. Am. M. Ass, 1939, 113: 1983.—Gnecco Mozo, F. Mas sobre el trabajo del coraz6n en Bogota. Rev. med. Bogota, 1936-37, 46: 49-62.—Goll- witzer-Meier, K. Die Energetik des Saugetierherzens. Klin. Wschr, 1939, 18: 225-31.------& Kriiger, E. Zur Ver- schiedenheit der Herzenergetik und Herzdynamik bei Druck- und Volumleistung. Arch. ges. Physiol, 1936, 238: 279-89. ------ . R. C. Spon- taneous iupmre of the heart. Am. J. Path.. 1628, 4: 249-55, 3 pl—('; rrell. R. C. Traumatic rupture of the heart. Med. Pull. (Standard Oil Co.) N. Y, 1939-41, 4: 419-2.3- Cesari Dcrrel, V. Di un caso di rottura traumatica del cuore senza emopcricardio. Arch, antrop. crim. Tor, 1927, 47: 453-66.— Chapelle, C. F. de la. Spontaneous rupture of the heart; an analysis of 1 1 cases. Am. Heart J, 1925-26, 1: 315-48. Also repr.—Chate, H. S. Lupture of the heart. Brit. M. J, 1927. 2: 15.—Cooper, G. W. Spontaneous rupture of the heart; with report of cases. I. S. Nav. M. Bull, 1927, 25: 343-52.— ( osUntini, E. Aneurisma spurio del cuore da endocardite ulcerosa maligna come cau-a di mituia spontanea del cuore. Cuore & circol, 1938, 22: 51(1 54- (raws-haw, C. W. Rupture of the heart. Brit. M. J, 1930. 1: 1173 —Davenport, A. B. Spontaneous heart rupture; a statistical summary. Am. J. M. Sc, 1928, 176: 62-5.—Delvaux, P. Lmpoisonnement suppose; mort par rupture du cceur. Presse med. beige, 1861, 13: 53.— Domenici. F. Sopra un caso in.-elito di rottura traumatica del cuore. Boll Soc. med. chir.. Pa via, 1937, 51: 1097-110 — Eichler, P. Herzruptur nach P.< ml ahnfahrt. Klin. Wschr, 1927, 6: 1519.—Feemster, R. F. .spontaneous rupture of the heart, Am. J. Path, 1931, 7: 223-7, pl—Ferris, H. W. Traumatic rupture of the heart; report of a case. Arch. Path, Chic, 1930, 9: 63.5-47. Also repr.—Fine!la, M. A. Delle rotture del cuore; Salluzzo, 1838. Ann. clin. Osp. incurab. Nap, 1840, 6: 70-9.—Flett, R. L. The musculature of the heart, with its application to physiology, and a note on heart rupture. J. Anat, Lond, 1927-28, 62: 439-75.—Fortney, A. C. Spontaneous rupture of the myocardium. J. Lancet, 1933, 53: 143-58.—Fragala, G. La rottura spontanea del cuore; rivista sintetico-critica e contributo casistico. Clin. med. ital, 1940, 71: 35-47.—Gerke, A. A. [Cases of spontaneous rupture of the heart] Klin, med, Moskva, 1929, 7: 188-96.—Goodall, J. S, & Weir, H. B. Rupture of the heart; an analysis of 18 cases. Brit. M. J, 1927, 1: 834 — Gunewardene, H. 6. Trau- matic rupture of the heart without external injuries. Ibid, 1934, 2: 942.—Gunn, F. D, & Stanley, A. M. A case of spon- taneous rupture of the heart. Bull. Buffalo Gen. Hosp, 1926. 4: 29-31.—Hallermann, W. Leber die Spontanruptur des Herzens. Deut. Zschr. gerichtl. Med, 1937 38, 29: 264-71 — Hamilton, J. A. Traumatic rupture of the heart without ex- ternal injuries. Brit, M. J, 1934, 2: 1101.—Hawkes, S. Z. Traumatic rupture of the heart and intrapericardial structures. Am. J. Surg, 1935, 27: 503-7. Also repr.—Heane, C. W. Rupture of the heart. J. R. Army Vet. Corps, 1940-41, 12: 85.—Ingle, S. R. Rupture of the heart (with slight, external marks of violence) Ind. M. Gaz, 1934, 69: 15(1. Invernizzi, G. Aneurismi dell'aoi ta e del cuore; contributo alio studio della rottura del cuore. Clin. med. ital, 1929, 60: 325-03.—Ismcrt. L'dchirures multiples du coRur. Bull. Soc. sc. v6t. Lyon, 1900, 3: 144- 6.- Ivanov, M. A. [Cases of multiple ruptures of the heart without injury to the thoracic cavity] Voen. med. J, Moskva, 1932, 3: 238.—Jaffe. R, & Bross, K. Befunde bei Herzrupturen (zugleich ein Beitrag zur Frage dei Angina pectoris) Zschr. klin. Med, 1933, 123: 63-84.- Jannoni Sebastianini, G. Rottura spontanea del cuore. Zacchia, 1926, 5: 104-10.—Kernbach, M, & Cotutiu, C. [Medico-legal diagnosis of 2 cases of spontaneous rupture of the heart] Cluj. med, 1929, 10: 279 84.—Khitrov, A. A. [Spontaneous rupture of the cardiac muscle] Klin, med, Moskva, 1933, 11: 1152.— Kissinger. P. Herzrupturen nach Leberfabren und Verschut- tung. Mschr. Lnfallh, 1927, 34: 283 —Krantzfeld, I. M. [Spontaneous rupture of the heart] Qdess. med. J, 1929, 4: 371- 80.—Kudo, M. L'eber einen Fall von spontaner Herzruptur. Taiwan igakkai zasshi, 1930, 25.—Legrand, R, & Nayrac, P. Mecanisme inhabituel d'une rupture cardiaque. C. rend. Soc. biol, 1929, 100: 885.—Levin'on, S. A. Medicolegal aspects of traumatic injuries and spontaneous rupture of the heart and aorta. Indust. M, 1941, 10: 424-7.—Limito, C. Sulle rotture spontanee del cuore. Boll. PoUamb. Giuseppe Ronzoni, 1933, 7: 497-511.—Locke, E. A. Five cases of spontaneous rupture of the heart. Boston M. & S. J, 1927, 197: 955-61.—Mc- Namara, F. P, Hancock, J. C, & Coady, G. C. Spontaneous rupture of the heart. J. Iowa M. Soc, 1937, 27: 210-2.— Marcq, L, & Hauchamps. Mort rapide par nipt me .-pontam'e du cam. Presse med. beige, 1868-69, 21: 93.— Markevich, M. [Classification of spontaneous heart ruptuies: clinical and pathologico-anat.omical] Sudeb. med. ekspertiza, 1928, 8-17.- Marshall, H. T. Rupture of a healthy-looking hypertrophied heart by muscular strain. South. M. J, 1929, 22: 442-8.— iVcnesini, G. Contributo alio studio delle rotture del cuore Rass. internaz. clin. ter, 1933, 14: 790-8.—Miller, J. Case of spontaneous rupture of the heart. Canad. M. Ass. J, 1928 19: 74-6.—Mir.ovici, N, & Bonciu, C. Considerations'sur 28 cas de ruptures spontanes du caur. Bull Acad. med. Roumaine, 1936, 2: 633-8.—Modi, J. P. Three cases of spontaneous rup- ture of the heait. In his Textb. Med. Jurispr, 6. ed, Bombay, 1940, 286.—Mohsin Ali Abbasi. Spontaneous rupture of the hearL Ind. M. Gaz, 1938, 73: 681.—Mondon, H, & Moreau, F. Rupture du (uur. Arch. mal. caur, 1939, 32: 263-5.— Nadler, R Zur 1 -"iage der spontanen Herzruptur (Herzruptur bei Geisteskranken; myomalazischer Septumdefekt; Koronar- zerreissungi Z.-ehr. Kreislaufforsch, 1935, 27: 689-96 — Nuzum, I. R, jahrigen Kinde. Wien. med. Wschr, 1926, 76: 668; 671.—Sulton, D. C. The treatment of chronic myocarditis. Illinois M. J, 1931, 59: 112-4.—Vassilides, D. Le traitement radical de la myocardite chronique (sclerose du cceur) Ann. med. phys, Anvers, 1931, 24: 163-6.—Warren, S. The pathology of chronic myocarditis. N. England J. M, 1933, 208: 573.—Whishaw, R. Chronic myocarditis. Med. J. AustraUa, 1937, 2: 837-41. ---- Tonus. See also subheading Elasticity; also Heart nerves* Sotjsa Martins, J. T. de. *0 pneumogastneo preside a tonicidade da fibra muscular do coracao. 80p. 8? Lisboa, 1866. Arvanitaki, A, & Cardot, H. Reactions electrotoniques du myocarde en fonction de son tonus initial. C. rend. Soc. biol, 1937, 124: 165-7.—Fleisch, A, & Tomaszewski, W. Zur Frage der nervos-vegetativen Beeinflussung des Herztonus. Arch. ges. Physiol, 1936-37, 238: 528-34.—Gherardini, G. Sul significato di alcuni cosidetti riflessi cardiaci in rapporto alia questione clinica del tono del cuore. Cuore & circol, 1929, 13: 298; 356.—JohnsDn, V, & Katz, L. N. Tonus in the mam- malian ventricle. Am. J. Physiol, 1936, 116: 86; 1937, 118: 26.—Katona, J. [Tonus] Gyogyaszat, 1926, 66: 723 — Lutembacher, R. Tonus et retraction passive du crjeur. Presse med, 1935, 43: 1546-50.—Manfredi, L. II tono del cuore. Gazz. med. lombarda, 1927, 86: 3.—Marmorstein, M. Con- tribution k l'etude de tonus de cceur chez le chien. J. physiol. path, gen, 1928, 26: 231-7.—Meek, W. J. The question of cardiac tonus. Phvsiol. Rev, 1927, 7: 259-87—Meldolesi, G. Su alcuni metodi clinici di esame della tonicity miocardica. Bull. Accad. med. Roma, 1926, 52: 109-15—Minerbi, C. La fase refrattaria tonotropa del miocardio e I'analogia di essa con lo stato disserrato della fibra muscolare liscia. Minerva med. Tor, 1927, 7: 11-8. ------Moncini, S, & Benassi, E. Fatti nuovi, e nuovi concetti intorno alia dottrina generale del tono neuro-muscolare del cuore. Policlinico, 1936, 43: sez. med., 62-104.—Moukhtar Ozden, A, Rifat Yarar, N, & Bechat S. G. Sur les tonicites neurogene et myogene du myocarde et des arteres. Arch. mal. cceur, 1936, 29: 46-58.—Pendl, E. Ver- suche iiber den Einfluss des Sinus auf den Tonus der Kalt- bluterkammer (Beobachtungen an R. fusca, R. esculenta, Emys europaea) Arch. ges. Physiol, 1936, 238: 176-83.—Pittiani G. La questione clinica del tono del cuore (rivista cntica) Cuore & circol, 1927, 11: 239-49.—Redfield, A. C, & Medeans, D. N. The content of lactic acid and the development of ten- sion in cardiac muscle. Am. J. Physiol, 1926, 77: 662-8 — Santucci, G. Studio flebografico della prova di Cardarelh- Katzenstein; contributo alia semiologia del tono del cuore. Clin. med. ital, 1932, 63: 143-71-Schaffer, H. Lntersuchun- gen uber den Tonus des Herzens. Med. Khn, Berl, 1927, 23: 1202.—Schwartz, A. Recherches sur le tonus du cceur. G. rend. Soc. biol, 1926, 94: 1365-8.—Schwartzman, J. S. [De- termination of tonus of the heart muscle] Vrach gaz, 1927, 31: 839; 1641. Also Miinch. med. Wschr, 1927,74: 19.— Siciliano, L. II tono del cuore. Riv. chn. med, 1926, 27: 7/9- 92. Also Med. Welt, 1927, 1: 1288-90. ---- Tonus: Disorder. See also Heart failure, congestive. Giraud-Costa, E. Comment teg'er des cures tonicardiaques par la voie buccale seule (schemas therapeutiques) Marseille med, 1930, 67: 187-202.—Kevdin, N. A. [Tonogenetic heart diseases] Klin, med, Moskva, 1927, 5: No. 6, 373-7.—La Zara, A. Variazioni del tono cardiaco in alcune affezioni cardiache. Cult. med. mod. Pal, 1936, 15: 169-80.—Lutem- bacher, R. Arret tonique du cceur. Ann. mid., Par, 1932, 31: 207-87.—Meldolesi, G. Contributo alio studio semeiologico e clinico del tono miocardico. Cuore & circol, 1926, 10: 265; 309.—Mougeot, A. L'hvpotonie myocardique essentielle. Progr. med. Par, 1932, 730-7— Ohm, R. Herzarbeitstonua und positiver Venenpuls. Klin. Wschr, 1927, 6: 1841-4.— Pende, N. Physiopathologie et semeiologie de la tonicite du ooeur; les dystonies myocardiques. Arch, mal cceur, 1932, 25: 73-93.—Rasumov, N. [Clinical cases of tonus of cardiac muscle and dystonia of the heart] Klin, med, Moskva, 1927, 5: 1204-75. ---- Tonus: Variation. Sulzer, R. *Untersuchungen iiber den dia- stolischen Tonus des Herzens. 19p. 8? [Ziir., 1927] Arvanitaki, A, & Cardot, H. Activite automatique et varia- tions du tonus. C. rend. Soc, biol, 1936, 121: 1480-2 — Bianchi, C, & Debiasi, E. Contributo alio studio della in- fluenza dello stato puerperale sulla funzione cardiaca, con speciale riguardo al tono miocardico. Arch, ostet. gin, 1939, 2. ser, 3: 227-87.—Bordet, E, & Fischgold, H. Test radio- kymographique des variations toniques du cceur. Bull, med. Par, 1936, 50: 876-8.—Danielopolu, D. Le tonus cardio- vasculaire normal et pathologique. Bull. Soc. med. hop. Bucarest, 1928, 10: 79-110.—Du Buisson. Action des aeides et des bases sur le tonus du muscle cardiaque d'Anodonta cygnea. Arch, internat. physiol, Liege, 1927, 29: 22-4.—Furuta, K. Die Tonusschwankungen des isolierten Reptilienherzens mit neuen Durchstromungsmethoden untersucht. Arch. ges. Physiol, 1932, 230: 94-101.—Grassmuck, A. Leber den Einfluss der Nerven auf die Tonusschwankungen des Schild- krotenherzens. Ibid, 1934-35, 235: 1-14— La Franca, S. Les variations du tonus cardiaque chez I'homme. Arch, internat. physiol, Liege, 1924, 23: 235-49. —---- Le modificazioni del tono e delle cavita. del cuore. Cult. med. mod. Pal, 1927, 6: 355-71. ------ Allenamento fisico e tono cardiaco. Rass. clin. sc, 1934, 12: 267-70.—Moukhtar, A. Action de quelques ions metalliques sur la tonicite isolee du myocarde. Schweiz. med. Wschr, 1935, 65: 281-3.—Roncato,-A. Le oscillazioni del tono del cuore nei mammiferi e loro relazione con le curve emodinamiche di II ordine. Arch, fisiol. Fir, 1933-34, 32: 232-9. Also Arch. ital. biol, 1933-34, 90: 1-8.—Schneider, G. Untersuchungen uber die Tonusschwankungen des Schild- krotenherzens. Zschr. vergl. Physiol, 1932, 16: 471-88.— Tomaszewski, W. [Effect of adrenalin and acetylcholine on the heart tonus] Polska gaz. lek, 1930, 15: 313-7.—Ueda, J, & Ro, T. Pharmakologische Untersuchungen iiber das Zirku- lationssystem der Schildkrote; Beitrage zur pharmakologischen Kenntnis der Tonusschwankung des Schildkrotenherzens. Jap. J. M. Sc, 1940, J3: Proc. Pharm, 24.—Walko, K. Ueber die Tonusschwankungen des Herzens JugendUcher. Med. Klin, Berl, 1933, 29: 904-7. HEART nerves. See also Autonomic nervous system; Heart- beat (Automatism; Regulation) Heart function; Heart muscle, Excitability, &c. Mahaim, I. *Les nerfs du coeur. 16p. 8° Lausanne, 1932. Barry, D. T. The course of cardiac nerve fibres in the pulmonary plexuses. J. Physiol, Lond, 1935-36, 84: 263-71.— Blackhall-Morison, A. Note on the innervation of the ventricle of the human heart. J. Anat, Lond, 1925-26, 60: 143-5, pl— Erez B M. [Innervation of the heart] Khn. med, Moskva, 1936' 14: 1463-8.—Kasahara, I. Morphologische Studien iiber'die Nervenverteilung im spezifischen Muskelsysteme des Herzens. Tr. Jap. Path. Soc, 1928, 18: 324-7 -Koch, E. Die Tonusgrosse der Herz- und Gef issnerven. \ erh Deut. Ges. Kreislaufforsch, 1933, 6: 59-67 [Discussion] 79-81 — Kondratiev, N. S. [Recent data on the anatomy of the extra- and intracardial nervous system] In Kardiol sess, Odessa, 1935 1 Congr 12-23.—Nonidez, J. F. Studies on the inner- vation of the heart; distribution of the cardiac nerves, with special reference to the identification of the sympathetic and parasympathetic postganglionics. Am. J. Anat, 1939, t.5. 361-413 6 d1 —Pastori, G. Sulla fine innervazione del cuore. Boll Soc. ital biol. sper, 1930, 5: 1108-13.-Schimert J. Die Nervenversorgung des Myokards Zschr. Zellforsch, 1937 27- 246-66—Seto, H. Mikroskopische Studien zur Innervation des menschlichen Herzens. Arb. Anat. Inst. Lniv. Sendai, 1936, H. 19, 1-47, 12 pl-Thomsen, E The nerves of the ventricle. Acta med. scand, 1926, Suppl, lb. yno-5 —Williamson, B. The clinical importance of cardiac fnnervation!Chn. J, Lond, 1938, 67; 271-80.-Woollard, HEART NERVES 344 HEART NERVES H. H. The innervation of the heart. J. Anat, Lond, 1925-26, 60: 345-73.—Worobiev. Leber die Nerven des Herzens. Med. Klin, Berl, 1926, 22: 925. ---- afferent and sensory [including Nn. cardiaci thoracales] Aleiander, J, Macleod, A. G, & Barker, P. S. Sensibility of the exposed human heart and pericardium. Arch. Surg, 1929, 19: 1470-83.—Fedele, M. Sui nervi centripeti cardiaci nei vertebrati. Boll. Soc. ital. biol sper, 1930, 5: 623-8.— Ionesco, D, & Enachesco, M. Les nerfs cardiaques thoraciques chez I'homme. C. rend. Soc. biol, 1927, 97: 980-2.------ Nerfs cardiaques naissant de la chaine thoracique du sym- pathique, au dessous du ganglion stellaire; les nerfs cardiaques thoraciques chez quelques mammif&res. Ibid, 977-80. -----— Untersuchungen bei Saugetieren und beim Menschen iiber die aus dem Brustgrenzstrang des Sympathicus unterhalb des Ganglion stellatum entsprungenen Herznerven; Nervi cardiaci thoracales. Zschr. ges. Anat, 1. Abt, 1928, 85: 476-89. ------ & Teitel Bernard, A. Leber eine neue Gruppe von sympathischen, aus dem Brustgrenzstrang, unterhalb des Ganglion stellatum, entsprungenen Herznerven (Nervi cardiaci thoracales) Klin. Wschr, 1928, 7: 991.—Ionesco, D, & Teitel Bernard, A. Les nerfs cardiaques thoraciques, voies sensitives du coeur. C. rend. Soc. biol, 1927, 97: 991.— Ionesco, D, Teitel Bernard, A. [et al] Sur la nature des nerfs cardiaques thoraciques. Ibid, 992-4. ------ Ueber die Funktionen der svmpathischen thorakalen Herznerven. Arch. ges. Physiol, 1928, 219: 47-58.—Jackson, D. E, & Matthews, S. A. The sensory nerves of the heart and blood vessels as a factor in determining the action of drugs. Am. J. Physiol, 1908, 21: 255-8.—Leriche, R, Fontaine, R, & Kunlin, J. Etude experimentale de la sensibilite du pericarde, de l'epicarde et de l'endocarde. C. rend. Soc. biol, 1932, 110: 297.— Mayne, W, & Katz, L. N. Observations on the path taken by the pain fibers from the heart. Am. J. Physiol, 1935-36, 114: 688-91.—Netlleship, W. A. Experimental studies on the afferent innervation of the cat's heart. J. Comp. Neur, 1936, 64: 115-33.—Nonidez, J. F. Studies on the innervation of the heart; afferent nerve endings in the large arteries and veins. Am. J. Anat, 1941, 68:151-89, 5 pl—Papilian, V, & Daghie. V. Les nerfs cardiaques thoraciques sousstellaires. C. rend. Soc. biol, 1928, 98: 61.—Soza, W. M. Fundamentos fisiol6gicos de la sensibiUdad cardfaca. Arch, med, Santiago, 1938, 5: 10; 34. ---- Bathmotropic action. Florkin, M. Action bathmotropique de l'excitation du pneumogastriipie sur l'estomac, appteciee chez la grenouille par la mesure de la chronaxie. Arch, internat. physiol, Liege, 1928-29, 30: 109-14.—Fredericq, H. L'action bathmotrope du sympathique cardiaque, appteciee, chez le chien, par la mesure de la chronaxie des extrasystoles ventriculaires. Ibid, 1924 25, 24: 113 IS ----■ L'action bathmotrope du piieuniugastiique caidiaque. appteciee, chez le chien, par la mesuie de la chrunaxie du myocarde ventriculaire. Ibid, 1924, 23: 108-73. Also (.'. rend. Soc. biol, 1924, 91: 1171-3. ------ Recherches chronaximetrjques: Taction bathmotrope des nerfs du ru-tir est une action directe. Ibid, 1926, 94: 1319. ------ La chronaxie du coeur des invertebtes (cepha- lopodes et crustaces decapodes) Taction bathmotrope des nerfs visceraux du poulpe. Bull Acad. Belgique, 1928, 5. ser, 14: cl sc, 524-9. Also Arch, internat. physiol, Liege, 1928-29, 30: 306-10.—Garrey, W. E, & Ashman, R. The excitabiUty of the turtle ventricle during vagus stimulation. Am. J. Physiol, 1931, 98: 102-8.—Mikchaleva, O. A. [Ueber den Einfluss der Herznerven (Vagus and Sympathicus) auf den Reizschwellwert und Chronaxie des Herzens] J. Physiol. USSR, 1935, 18: 548-63— Nowinski, V. W. Einfluss der Vagusreizung auf die Erregbarkeit der verschiedenen Herz- abschnitte. Zschr. Biol, 1930-31, 91: 152-8.—Shoshina, N. A. [State of heart excitability according to data of chronaximetry during excitation of the vagus] J. Physiol. USSR, 1940, 28: 515-23.—Somer, E. de. Au sujet de l'extra-systole et de Taction du vague sur le coeur. Bull. Acad, med. Par, 1937 3. ser, 117: 565-73. ---- Cardio-accelerators. See also Sympathetic nervous system; Vagus. Boeke, J. Innervationsstudien; der sympathlsche Grund- plexus und seine Beziehungen zu den quergestreiften Muskel- fasern und zu den Herzmuskelfasern. Zschr. mikr anat Forsch, 1933, 34: 330-78.—Brinley, F. J. A possibility of a sympathetic innervation of the fish heart. Proc Soc Exp Biol. N. Y, 1933, 31: 122-4.—Brouha, L, Dill, D. B, ,s morpho- logische Substiat dei funktionellen Verbindung der autonomen \ agusfassern nut den intiamuralen Ganglienzellen des Herzens. Anat. Anz, 1930, 83: 19-25.—Monnier, A. M, & Dubuisson, M. Les potentiels d'action du cordon nerveux ganglionnaire cardiaque de Limulus polyphemus observes k l'oscillographe cathodique. Arch, internat. physiol, Liege, 1931, 34: 196- 221.— Okamura, ('. Ueber die Ganglienzellen in der Herzwand. /.-dir. ges. Anat, 1. Abt, 1929, 89: 31 1 -66— Pannier, R. I loimees generates sur le systeme ganglionnaiie et paraganglion- i lie du caur. C. rend. Soc. biol, 1935, 120: 1350-3.— Kijlunt, P. L'activite du ganglion cardiaque de la Umule pohplidme. Ibid, 1931, 108: 828-30. ------ Etude a Toscillographe cathodique du ganglion cardiaque de la limule pnlypheme. Ibid, 1144-7.—Samojloff, A. The extra systolic impul-e of the ganglion of Limulus heart. Am. J. Physiol, 1930, 93: lNi-9.—Suzuki, S. On the distribution of ganglion cells in the heart of the oyster. Tohoku Univ. Sc. Rep, 1934, 8: 335; 9: 111. •------ GangUon cells in the heart of Ligia exotica ilioux) Ibid, 213-7. ------ On the presence of ganglion ceUs in some crustacean hearts. Ibid, 1935, 10: 417-26.--Szantroch, Z. [Histogenesis of the nerve ganglions of the heart] Bull, internat. Acad, polon. sc, 1930, ser. B, 2: (zoology) 417-31, 10 pl.—Szcpsenwol, J, & Bron, A. L'origine des cellules nerveuses sympathiques dans le cceur des oiseaux (embrvons de canard et de poulet) C. rend. Soc. biol, 1935, 118: 1030. ---- Inotropic action. Fredericq, H. La marge de Teffet inotrope du pneumogastri- que cardiaque en fonction du nombre et de Tintensite des stimuli. C. rend. Soc. biol, 1933, 112: 1553-6. ------ La profondeur de la depression inotropique produite par le pneumogastrique cardiaque de la tortue, en fonction du voltage et de la frequence des stimuli. Ibid, 1934, 115: 1723-6. ------ Sommation, chez la tortue, des effets inotropes cardiaques de la stimulation des 2 pneumogastriques au moyen de stimuU isoies. Ibid, 1937, 126: 243. ------ Sommation, chez la tortue, des effets cardiaques inotropes de 2 stimuli vagaux se succ6dant k des intervaUes variables du temps. Ibid, 58-60. ------ La p6riode tefractaire secondaire de I'appareil cardio-inhibiteur de la tortue; action inotrope d'une stimulation vagale iterative k la frequence optimale et k basse frequence. Arch, internat physiol, Liege, 1938, 47: 444-52.—Kisch, B. Treppe und \ aguswirkung. Arch. ges. Physiol, 1934-35, 235: 638-43 — Rothberger, C. J, & Scherf, D. Wirkt der Vagus auf die Kontrakuoiisstarke der Lammem des Saugetierherzens' Zschr. ges. exp. Med, 1930, 71 : 27 1 V, Tamura, M. Studies on the staircase phenomenon of the isolated toad's heart Sei i kwai, 1927, 46: No. 7, 14. ---- Mode of action. Befsmetny, C. *Ueber die Beziehungen zwischen Vagus und Accelerans [Bern] 41n 8? Munch., 1905. V' Alexandrowicz, J. S. Quelques experiences sur le fonction- ncment du svstcme nerveux du cceur des erustaees isopoles. C. rend. Soc. biol, 1931, 108: 1270-2.—Appelrot, S, & Carlson, A. J. The influence of the vago-sympailetic nerves on the ventriculo-aortic tonus in the turtle. Am. .1. Phvsiol. 1930 95: 56-63.—Ashor. L, & Bunrae, T. Leber die Wirkungs- weise der Herznerven und die Wirkungsstirke f the heart] Voen. san. delo, 1936, No. 0, 36-42. Schultz, II. Beitrag zur Frage der Entstehung von Herzneurosen durch den Kriegsdienst. Klin. Wschr, 1937, 16: 15-7.—Soldier's heart. Med. Rec, X. Y, 1942, 155: 2.— Thomas, D. Das sogenannte erregbare Soldatenheiz. Deut. med. Wschr, 1940, 66: 989-92. ---- Pathology, and physiopathology. Benard, R. Erethisme cardiaque des adolescents et tension arterielle. Bull. Soc. med. h6p. Paris, 1937, 3. ser, 53: 799- 805.—Burridge, W. Responsiveness, hysteresial change and kinesiphores. Sunti Congr. internaz. fisiol, 1932, 14. Congr, 45.—Celansky, V. [Various theories and clinical experiences in cardiac neuroses] Cas. lek. desk, 1937, 76: 837-47.— Cossio, P, Berconsky, I, & Del Castillo, E. B. L'eprcuve de la vitesse sanguine k l'effort. Bull. Soc. med. hop. Paris, 1937, 3. ser, 53: 220-30.—Deutsch, F, & Kauf, E. Ps.vcho-physische Kreislaufstudien; iiber die Ursachen der Kreislaufstorungen bei den Herzneurosen. Zschr. ges. exp. Med, 1923, 34: 71—81.— Filip, L. [Results of clinical examination of sportsmen's hearts] Cas. lek. desk, 1926, 65: 1691-7.—Hoffmann, A. Kreislauf- storungen ohne objektiven organischen Befund am Herzen und an den Gefassen (Herzneurosen) Jahrkurs. arztl Fortbild, 1923, 14: H. 2, 1-16.—Pruche, A. Etude physio-pathologique des nevroses cardiaques. Presse therm, clim. Par, 68: 375- 8.—Schnur, S. Cardiac neurosis associated with organic heart disease. Am. Heart J, 1939, 18: 153-65. Also .Med. Rec, Houston, 1940, 34: 582-90.—Willius, F. A. Cardiac neurosis and heart disease. Proc. Mayo Clin, 1941, 16: 575. ---- Prognosis. Delius, L. Die Prognose nervoser Herzbesch werden. Deut. med. Wschr, 1941, 67: 100-2.—Deutsch, F. Das Sportherz- problem. Aerztl. Prax, Wien, 1934, 8: 232-8.—Evidence; medical expert witness required to state basis of his opinion. J. Am. M. Ass, 1940, 115: 1482.—Gaisbock, F. Ueber soge- nannte nervose Herzbeschwerden und Eignung zum Sport. Med. Klin, Berl, 1935, 31: 1524-8—Griinbaum, F. Ver- schlimmerung einer Herzneurose durch Grippe? Uebergang in ein organisches Herzleiden? Ibid, 1932, 28: 556.—Importance (The) of cardiac neurosis. Med. J. Australia, 1937, 2: 484. ---- Sympathicotonia. See also Heart rate, Tachycardia. Gallavardin, L., & Tourniaire, A. Les nevroses tachycardiques. 120p. 8? Par., 1935. Gravier, L, Tourniaire, A, & Gonnet, J. Quelques tesultats de la radiotherapie dans les nevroses tachycardiques. Lyon med, 1936, 157: 626-31.—Shalabutov, K. V. [Reflex of the sympathetic nerve and the sympathicotonic pulse] Nevropat. psikhiat, 1937, 6: 96-9.—Tourniaire, A.-* Evolution et traite- ment des nevroses tachycardiques. Gaz. nted. France, 1934, 176-82. ------ Nevroses tachycardiques et alterations myo- cardiques. Arch. mal. cceur, 1935, 28: 47-50. ----- & Bret, J. Indications et resultats des interventions sympathiques et de la radiotherapie dans le traitement dos nevroses tachy- cardiques. Gaz. med. France, 1938, 45: 189-91. ---- Treatment. Bad-Natjheim. Vereinigung der Bad-Nau- heimer Aerzte. Herzneurosen und moderne Kreislauftherapie. 159p. 8? Dresd., 1932. Fournial, C. J. *Des nevroses cardiaques et leur traitement par l'adenosine. 56p. 25V£cm. Par., 1939. Beier, D. C. Conditioned cardiovascular responses and suggestions for the treatment of cardiac neuroses. J. Exp. Psychol, 1940, 26: 311-21.—Conner, L. A. Cardiac neuroses. In Diagn. Treat. Cardiovasc. Dis. (Stroud, W. D.) Phila, 1940, 1: 196-207.—Curtius, O. Diskussionsvortrag: Herzneurose und Psychotherapie. Verh. Deut. Ges. inn. Med, 1936, 48. Kongr, 76-80.—Deutsch, F. Prophylaxe und Therapie des Sport- herzens. Wien. klin. Wschr, 1930, 43: 118-20.—Di Prisco. II trattamento delle palpitazioni cardiache da distonia neuro- vegetativa. Morgagni, 1934, 76: 1094.—Elsiisser, B. Be- handlung der Herzneurosen mit Valeriana-Digitalysat. Med. Welt, 1928, 2: 409.—Ferguson, D. R. Homeopathic therapy in neurocirculatory asthenia. J. Am. Inst. Homeop, 1935, 28: 731-3.—Geronne, A. Die nervbsen Storungen des Herzens und ihre Behandlung. Med. Welt, 1933, 7: 304.—Glendy, R. E, & White, P. D. The recognition and treatment of cardiac neurosis. Med. Clin. N. America, 1937, 21: 449-65.—Grandjean, F. Ein Beitrag zur Behandlung der herzneurotischen Storungen und der Schlaflosigkeit Tuberkuloser. Schweiz. med. Wschr, 1935, 65: 1004-0.—Hausner, E. Zur Therapie nervoser Herz storungen. Ther. Gegenwart, 1935, 76: 202-5.—Heard, J. D. Symposium on c.-irdiovascular di-.ea.-e; management of patients with heart symptom, of nervous uii;iii, Pennsylvania M. J, 1933, 36: 661-3.-—Karcher, M. Beitrag zur Bchaudlung von Herzneurosen und KompeiLsationsitorungen. Zbl. Herz Gefiisskr, 1926, 18: 397-400.—Kronfeld, A. Kreislaufneurosen bzw. Herzneurosen vom Standpunki des Psychothc-apeuten. In Herzneurosen [etc.] (Bad-Xauheim Ver. Aerzte) Dicsd, 1932, HEART NEUROSIS 353 HEART RATE 18-29 —Miiller-Stade, E. Ueber die sogenannte Herzneurose und ihre Behandlung. Hippokrates, Stuttg, 1938, 9: 1073-6 — Neumann, R. Beitrag zur therapeutischen Beeinflussung der Neurosis cordis und nervosen Hypertonien. Deut. Aerzte Ztg, 1933, 8: No. 389.—Ortiz Ramirez, T. Tratamiento de la neurotonia cardfaca, neurosis cardiaca. Arch. lat. amer. card, Mex 1939, 9: 273-83.—Parade, G. W. Ist das Sportherz behandlungsbediirftig? Ther. Gegenwart, 1941, 82: 97-100 — Parmenter, G. H. The irritable heart and its treatment. U. S. Veterans Bur. M. BUU., 1926, 2: 1127-33.—Reid, W. D. The treatment of neurosis (cardiac) N. England J. M, 1930, 202: 264-9.—Warlo, R. Weitere Erfahrungen mit Corydalon, ein Beitrag zur Therapie der Herzerkrankungen, insbesondere der Herzneurosen. Fortsch. Ther, 1927, 3: 327-9.—Willius, F. A. Clinic on cardiac neurosis; comments and management. Proc. Mayo Clin, 1935, 10: 97-100. --- Vagotonia. See also Heart arrhythmia; Heart rate, Bra- dycardia. Doxiades, L. Das Vagusherz im Kindesalter. Klin. Wschr, 1926, 5: 2211.—Frey, W. Das Vagusherz. Ibid, 249-52.— Gumpert, T. E. A vasovagal attack. Lancet, Lond, 1936, 1: 85.—Hartl, K. Die Erklarung vegetativ bedingter Herz- rhythmusanderungen im Rahmen des klinischen Gesamtbildes. Deut. Arch. klin. Med, 1933-34, 176: 443-52.—Hindman, S. Vagotonia with normal bradycardia. Med. Bull. Veterans Admin, 1940-41, 17: 401.—Hoffstaedt, E, & Rosenbaum, E. Tympanale Vagusreizung bei Vagusherz. Deut. med. Wschr, 1928, 54: 704.—Krajewski, F. [Vagotony of the heart in sports- men] Lek. wojsk, 1935, 26: 533-40.—Mallardo, C. A. Con- siderazioni sulle bradiaritmie clinostatiche. Morgagni, 1933, 75: 963-75, 2 pl—Romano, N, Mazzei, E. S, & Baila, M. R. Bigeminismo y trigeminismo clinostaticos; manifestacion cardfaca de vagotonia. Rev. med. lat. amer, B. Air, 1934-35, 20: 961-71. - --- in children. Acuna, M, & Puglisi, A. Neurosis cardiaca en la infancia- Arch, argent, pediat, 1941, 15: 278.—Lincoln, E.M. The hearts of normal children; clinical studies, including notes on effort syndrome. Am. J. Dis. Child, 1928, 35: 398-410.—Puglisi, A. Neurosis cardiaca en la infancia. Sem. med, B. Air, 1940, 47: 1139. Also Arch, argent, pediat, 1941, 15: 362-9. HEART rate. See also Heartbeat; Heart function; Pulse. Boas, E. P., & Goldschmidt, E. F. The heart rate. 166p. 8? Springfield, 111., 1932. Knoll, A. P. *Untersuchungen iiber die normale Pulsfrequenz der Rinder und Schweine nebst vergleichenden physiologischen kritischen Studien iiber die normale Pulsfrequenz des Menschen und der Haussaugetiere [Zurich] 76p. 8? Dresd., 1911. Bowerman, W. G, & Brett, J. H. Pulse rates. Q. Rev. Biol, 1941, 16: 90-9. Also repr.—Cadbury, W. W. The normal rate of the pulse in Cantonese students. China M. J, 1922, 36: 170-6.—Dock, W. Heart rate and size; their impor- tance to the physician. California West. M, 1931, 34: 236- 40.—Garven, H. S. D. Pulse rates and ratios in Chinese stu- dents. Chin. J. Physiol, 1928, rep. ser, 97-105.—Matsuno, K. Observations on heart rates. Jap. J. M. Sc, 1938-39, 5: Proc. Int. Med, 226.—Occhiuto, A. Ricerche statistiche sulla frequenza del polso in soggetti maschi italiani. Arch. sc. biol, Bologna, 1938, 24: 281-302.—Rihl, J. Die Frequenz des Herzschlages. In Handb. norm. path. Physiol. (A. Bethe, G. Bergmann) Berl, 1926, 7: T. 1, 449-522.—Ruddy, J. O. Observations on the pulse rates of the foreign staff in Eastern Venezuela. Med. Bull. (Standard Oil Co.) N. Y, 1936-38, 3: 160-3. --- Bradycardia. See also Heart arrhythmia; Heart block. Jacob, M. *Bradykardie. 27p. 8? Berl., 1932. Berard. Bradycardie totale chez un vieillard, particuliere- ment influencable par la compression du pneumogastrique. Loire med, 1927, 41: 272.—Geill, T. [Case of pronounced bradycardia with appearance of escaped beats] Ugeskr. laeger, 1931, 93: 568-70.—Giroux, b. Les bradycardies. Bruxelles med, 1932-33, 13: 175-87.—Jauzion. Du ralentisse- ment progressif des battements du coeur. J. med. Toulouse, 1866, 4. ser, 5: 24-6.—Orsi, A. Su una forma complessa di bradicardia. Cuore & circol, 1927, 11: 14-22.—Sieber, E. Bradykardie. Sborn. lek, 1911, 12: 95-146.—Stones, R. Y. A case of bradycardia in a Muganda. East Afr. M. J, 1935-36, 12: 89. --- Bradycardia: Diagnosis. Aubarede, H. d'. Bradycardie k 24; possibilites du diag- nostic sans eiectro-cardiogramme. Monde med, 1939, 49: 506-8.—Bnto Foresti, C. El diagn6stico de las bradicardias. An. Fac. med, Montev, 1929, 14: 349-64, 2 pl—Chernikov, E. A, Barinskaia, E. A. [et al] [Coefficient of reduced ampli- tude and frequency of the pulse for functional diagnosis of circulatory conditions]. Klin, med, Moskva, 1933, 11: 442-7.— Fredericq, H, & Descamps, A. Le diagnostic pathogenique des bradycardies et les epreuves de l'atropine et du nitrite d amyle. Arch, internat. physiol, Liege, 1921, 16: 162-71.— Goldsteinas, L. [Differential diagnosis; bradycardia] Medi- cina, Kaunas, 1940, 21: 203-12.—Jouve, A. X. Les agents pharmaco-dynamiques dans le diagnostic et le traitement des bradycardies. Marseille med, 1939, 76: 226-40.—Stienon, E. Les fausses bradycardies. Ann. Inst. chir. Bruxelles, 1929, 30: 41-9.—Veil, P. Diagnostic eiectrocardiographique des brady- cardies. J. m6d. fr, 1930, 19: 433-7. ---- Bradycardia: Etiology. See also subheading Variation; also names of primary pathological conditions as Jaundice, &c. Auffret, J. *Les bradycardies d'origine digestive. 80p. 8? Par., 1936. Gebatjer, H. *Zur Frage der Bradykardie nach Vitamin B-Mangel beziehungsweise der Unterernahrung bei Ratten. 17p. 21cm. Bresl., 1937. Achard, C, & Touraine, A. Trois observations de bradycar- die au cours d'infections. Bull Soc. med. hop. Paris, 1911, 3. ser, 32: 19-27.—Bard, L. Du role des pressions intra- cardiaques dans le mecanisme des rythmes bradycardiques pathologiques. Arch. mal. coeur, 1926, 19: 1-20.—Bennett, A. L., Burke, J. C, & Mclntyre, A. R. Dietary bradycardia and sensitivity to ouabain in the dog. Am. J. Physiol, 1939, 126: 431.—Bierring, E, Larsen, K, & Nielsen, E. Some cases of slow pulse associated with electrocardiographic changes in heart patients after maximal work on the Krogh ergometer. Acta med. scand, 1936, Suppl, 78, 150.—Binet, L, & Perles, L. Sur la bradycardie icterique. Bull. Soc. med. hop. Paris, 1929, 3. ser, 53: 981-4.—Borries, G. V. T. Pulsverlangsamung bei Labyrinthitis und bei Augenkrankheiten. Mschr. Ohrenh, 1927, 61: 205-16.—Buisson, P. Accidents nerveux et bredy- cardie. In Actual med. chir. (Fac. med. Marseille) 1939, 4. ser, 63-78.—Curtin, R. G. Bradycardia as a symptom. Tr. Am. Clim. Ass, 1903, 19: 252-5. Also repr.—Decourt, J, & Bascourret, M. Les bradycardies au cours des affections gastro- intestinales. J. nted. fr, 1932, 21: 311.—Doumer, E. A propos des bradycardies et des syncopes d'origine digestive. Bull. Soc. med. hop. Paris, 1936, 3. ser, 52: 81-3.—Dumitresco- Mante, D, & Hagiesco, D. Contributions k l'etude du tonus vegetatif dans la bradycardie icterique. Bull. Soc. med. hop. Bucarest, 1927, 9: 147; 1928, 10: 151. Also Bull. Soc. med. hop. Paris, 1928, 3. ser, 52: 1224-31. ------& Petresco, M. Sur le mecanisme de la bradycardie icterique; bradycardie sans choiemie spline mais avec cholinemie. Bull. Acad, med. Par, 1928, 3. ser, 100: 881-4.—Dumitresco-Mante, D, Hagiesco, D. [et al] Nouvelles recherches sur la bradycardie icterique. Presse med, 1929, 37: 34-6.—Fogelson, L. I. [Slowing of the pulse rate (bradycardia); pathogenesis and importance in evaluation of working capacity] Sovet. klin, 1931, 15: 303-12.—Gallenga, R. Bradicardia da ipertensione orbitaria. Gior. Accad. med. Torino, 1933, 96: pt 2, 122-5.— Geraudel, E, Benard, R, & Hillemand, P. Un second cas de bradyrythmie ventriculaire par stenose de l'artere du ventriculo-necteur. Arch. mal. coeur, 1926, 19: 281-94.— Ormond. A. P. Bradycardia due to spontaneous hypoglycemia: report of a case. J. Am. M. Ass, 1936, 106: 1726-8.—Parade, G. W. Vitamin BiUntersuchungen; zur Frage des Zusammen- banges zwischen Vitamin Bi-Mangel und Bradykardie. Zschr. Vitaminforsch, Bern, 1937, 6: 327-34.—Pletnev, D. D. K voprosu o bradikardii. Prakt. vrach, S. Peterb, 1911, 10: 489-91.—Raymond, L. Crises nerveuses et bradycardie. Presse med, 1933, 41: 786.—Smirnov, A. I. [Central, tonic and reflex retardations of the heart rhythm] Klin, med, Moskva, 1928, 6: 385-90. ------ & Olefirenko, P. D. Die reflektorische Verlangsamung des Herzrhythmus in Abhangig- keit von der Veranderung des Elektrolytenspiegels im Blut. Zschr. ges. exp. Med, 1927, 57: 559-64.—Vedrani, G. Delia bradicardia nei corso delle malattie infettive. Pensiero med, 1930, 19: 575-81. ---- Bradycardia, juvenile. De Toni, G. Le bradicardie nei bambini (studio critico e contributo personale) Clin, pediat. Mod, 1926, 8: 1; 65.— Mikulowski, V. Contribution k l'etude de la bradycardie constante chez l'enfant. Rev. fr. pediat, 1936, 12: 805-11.— Moderatov, P. S. [Pathogenesis of bradycardia in childhood] Sovet. pediat, 1935, No. 8, 118-21.—Pilod & Meersseman. A propos d'un cas de bradycardie juvenile. Bull. Soc. med. mil. fr, 1929, 13: 69-74.—Rud, E. [Case of bradycardia in a young man] Ugeskr. laeger, 1937, 99: 167-9. ---- Bradycardia: Pathology. Gross, D. Sobre la significaci6n din&mica de la bradicardia. Prensa med. argent, 1936, 23: 365-71.—Hoke, E, & Rihl, J. Experimentelle Untersuchungen iiber die Pulsverspatung. 227475—vol. 7, 4th series----23 HEART RATE 354 HEART RATE Wien. klin. Wschr, 1913, 26: 1149-52.—Keys, A, & Violente, A. Size and stroke of the normal human heart during neo- synephrin bradycardia. Proc. Soc. Exp. Biol, N. Y, 1940, 44: 462-4.—Marchal, G, & Trocme, P. Svncopes et bradycardies. Ann. med. Par, 1926, 20: 248-87.—White, P. D. Synchronous inspiration and systole in a patient exhibiting equal respiratory and pulse rates. Boston M. & S. J, 1915, 173: 548. ---- Bradycardia, permanent. EtchIsbarxe, M. Contribution a l'etude de la pathogenie du pouls lent permanent. 90p. 8? Par., 1928. Fayaud, R. Contribution a l'etude du pouls lent permanent. 48p. 8? Montp., 1910. Audibert, V, Mosinger [et al] Malformation cardiaque, pouls lent permanent; diabete, ei>ilepsie bravais jacksonienne. Marseille med, 1937, 74: 431-3— Boukspan. Un cas de bradycardie atrio-ventriculaire permanente. Arch. mal. coeur, 1928, 21: 802-8.—De Candia, S. Un caso di bradi- cardia permanente di difficile interpretazione (ritmo settale permanente o blocco totale con fibrillazione atriale?) Minerva med. Tor, 1929, 9: pt 2, 189-93.—De Guise, A. Pouls lent permanent. Union med. Canada, 1928, 57: 259-65.—Dogliotti, G. C, Montuschi, E, & Beretta, A. Studi di emodinamica in due casi di polso lento permanente. Minerva med. Tor, 1936, 27: pt 2, 497-504.—Doumer, E. Guerison d'un cas de pouls lent permanent. Bull. Soc. med. hop. Paris, 1936, 3. ser, 52: 1452-6.—Fernos Isern, A. Un caso de bradicardia per- manente con paralisis de las auriculas; estudio electrocardio- grAfico. Bol. As. med. Puerto Rico, 1939, 31: 82-5.—Fiessinger, N. Pouls lent permanent. Bull med. Par, 1913, 27: 769- 71.—Montero, E. Un caso de pulso lento permanente. An. Hosp. S. Jose, Madr, 1929-30, 1: 187-9.—Mouquin, M. Pouls lent permanent. Bull, med. Par, 1935, 49: Suppl, No. 29.—Pice, D. Un caso di bradicardia nodale permanente (studio elettrocardiografico) Rinasc. med, 1928, 5: 437-40.— Parvu, M. Sur un cas de faux pouls lent permanent. Arch. mal. cceur, 1920, 13: 250-3.—Plumier, L. L. Un cas de pouls lent permanent. Scalpel, Liege, 1910-11, 63: 667-9.—Reid, W. D. Permanent bradycardia following diphtheria, case report. Am. Heart J, 1929-30, 5: 524-7.—Stokes, W. Ob- servations on some cases of permanently slow pulse. Med. Classics. 1938-39, 3: 727-38. Also In Cardiac Classics (Willius, F. A.) S. Louis, 1941, 462-9.—Wybauw. Un cas de pouls lent permanent. Policlinico, Brux, 1909, 18: 69-71. ---- Bradycardia, paroxysmal. See also Heart block. Geraudel, E. Pouls lent paroxystique avec accidents synco- paux sans trouble de la conduction du faisceau de His; arythmie sinusale; bradyventriculie par automatisme dans les phases de bradysinusie. Arch. mal. coeur, 1929, 22: 163-71, pl.—Tisseull, J. Syndrome paroxystique de rythme synchrone cardio- pulmonaire. Bull. Soc. path, exot. Par, 1932, 25: 964.— Uhlenbruck, P. Ueber eine eigentiimliche Form paroxysmal bradykardischer Anfalle. Klin. Wschr, 1929, 8: 107-9. ---- Bradycardia, sinus. Herrmann, G. Sinus bradycardia. In Cyclop. Med. (Piersol-Bortz) Phila, 1939, 3: 854-6.—Ledoux, E. Brady- cardie nodale avec accidents syncopaux. Arch. mal. coeur, 1935, 28: 541-4.—Lian, C. A propos de la communication de MM. Mougeot et Lemaire sur un cas de bradycardie nodale. Bull. Soc. med. hop. Paris, 1928, 3. ser, 52: 356.—Morgan, P. W. The status of persons with sinus bradycardia. J. Kansas M. Soc, 1936, 37: 455; 469.—Mougeot, A, & Lemaire, A. Sur un cas de bradycardie nodale. Bull. Soc. med. hop. Paris, 1928, 3. ser, 52: 210-46—Olmer, J., Buisson, P., & Audier, M. 'Bradycardie sinusale avec crises nerveuses; action sur les electrocardiogrammes de l'atropine intraveineuse. Ibid, 1935, 3. ser, 51: 638-40.—Patrizi, M. L. Le recenti esperienze ed ipotesi sul seno carotideo non infirmano l'inter- pretazione classica del fenomeno Czermak-Concato (bradi- cardia da stimolo meccanico diretto del vago) Boll Soc. ital biol. sper, 1930, 5: 668-71.—Winternitz, M, & Selye, H. Ein Fall von Sinusbradykardie durch Sinusarterienthrombose Wien. Arch. inn. Med, 1928-29, 16: 377-80. ---- Bradycardia: Treatment. Donzelot, E. Les bradycardies et leur traitement. In Ther. med. i Loeper, M.) Par, 1933, 6: 165-75.—Hamburger, W. W. Significance and management of the bradycardias Med. Clin. N. America, 1939, 23: 93-106.—Henrijean. Traite- ment du pouls lent. C. rend. Congr. fr. med. (1910) 1911, 11: 4-7.—Lian. C. Tratamiento de las bradicardias. D ia med ' B. Air, 1931-32, 4: 401.—Livingstone, H. M, McFetridge, s! E, & Brunner, R. Profound blood pressure fall with brady- cardia; a normal pulse rate in surgical procedures. Surg Gyn Obst, 1933, 56: 917-25.—Routier, D. Traitement des brady- cardies. Gaz. med. France, 1930, 489-92. ---- Bradycardia—in animals. MacDonald, D. G. H, & McHenry, E. W. Studies on rat bradycardia. Am. J. Physiol, 1939-40, 128: 608-14.—Spitz, G. Bradycardie permanente et epistaxis, chez un cheval. Bull. Soc. centr. med. vet. Par, 1902, 56: 143-5. ---- Chemical control. See also Heartbeat, Regulation; Heart muscle, Pharmacology; Heart nerves, Pharmacology. Armstrong, G. W. J., it Fisher, K. C. The effect of sodium azide on the frequencv of the embryonic .fish heart. Am. J Physiol, 1939, 126: 423. Also J. Cellul. Physiol, 1940, 16: 103-12.—Belehradek, J. L'effet de la cafeine sur la grandeur du coefficient de temperature du rythme cardiaque. Arch. internat. physiol, Liege, 1932, 35: 1-8.—Heymans, J. F, 4 Heymans, C. Sur le mecanisme de la bradycardie consecutive k l'injection de digitale, strophantine et cymarine. J. Pharm. Exp. Ther, 1926. 29: 203-22— Hsu, F. Y. The effect of adrena- ine and acetyl-choline on the heart rate of the chick embryo. Chin. J. Physiol. 1933, 7: 243-51. Izquierdo. J. J. Influencia ejercida por los liquidos normals de perfusi6n sobre el ritmo fundamental del corazon de la rana. Rev. med. Barcelona, 1930, 13: 59-70.- Keys, A, & Violante, A. Production of bradycardia in normal man by neosynephrin (l-a-hydroxy-0- methylamino-3-hvdroxvethvlhenzoue hydrochloride) Proc. Soc. Exp. Biol, N. V, 1940. 44: 4-7.—Lewis, W. H. The effect of various solutions and salts on the pulsation rate of isolated hearts from young chick embryos. Contr. Embrvol. Carnegie Inst, 1929, 20: 173-92.—M'Dowall, R. J. S. the chemical control of the heart-rate. Q. J. Exp. Phvsiol, Lond, 1933, 23: 269-76.—Matthes, K. Ueber den Mechanismus der Pulsverlangsamung durch Morphin. Arch. exp. Path, Lpz, 1929, 145: 225-37.—Segers, M. La modification du pouvoir d'accommodation de la frequence du rythme cardiaque; action du calcium, du potassium, de l'adrenaline et de l'acetvlcholine. C. rend. Soc. biol, 1939, 130: 789-92.—Spealman, (''. R. The effects of CaCl, KC1, CaCh, and osmotic pressure on the frog- heart rate. Am. J. Physiol, 1938, 124: 185-91. ------ The action of osmotically-active substances on the heart rate. Ibid, 1940, 129: 293-6. ------ Osmotically-active substances and the frog-heart rate. Ibid, 469.—Steinhaus, A. H, Jenkins, T. A, & Lunn, J. J. The heart rate of dogs breathing normal and oxygen-rich air. Ibid, 1930, 92: 436-9.—Suzuki, T. Influence of intravenous administration of peptone upon the frequency of the denervated heart of the cat. Tohoku J. Exp. M, 1928-29, 12: 571-6.—Zwaardemaker, H, & Zeehuisen, H. Automatindosis und Frequenz des Herzschlages. Arch. ges. Physiol, 1927-28, 218: 568-72. ---- Correlations. See also Basal metabolism; Respiration, &c. Gauthereau, R. Contribution a l'etude des variations du rapport du pouls a la respira- tion a l'etat physiologique et a l'etat pathologi- que; valeur s6m6iologique de ce rapport. 95p. 8? Par., 1908. Anrep, G. V, Pasqual, W., & Roessler. Respiratory varia- tions of the heart rate. Sunti Congr. internaz. fisiol, 1932, 14. Congr, 8.—Bohme, W, & Hinrichsen, R. Ueber die Veranderungen der Pulsation des Herzens wahrend der Atmung im Zusammenhang mit einer Funktion des Herzbeutels. Fortsch. Rontgenstrahl, 1938, 57: 65-73.—De Somer, E. A propos d'echappement ventriculaire; electrocardiographic de l'acceiera- tion inspiratoire ou des courbes de Traube-Hering. Marseille med, 1939, 76: pt 2, 100-4.—Dob rev, M. Ueber das Ver- haltnis der Atmungsfrequenz zu der Herzfrequenz bei einer Scefischart. Pubb. Staz. zool. Napoli, 1933-34, 13: 326-30 — Hitzenberger, K, & Hinteregger, F. Ueber die herzsynchronen Zacken im Pneumotachogramm. Med. Klin, Berl, 1932, 28: 972.------Ueber kardiopneumotachographische Kurven. Mitt. Ges. inn. Med. Wien, 1932, 31: 59—Noehren, A. H, & Schwenk, E. Relation of basal metabolic rate to pulse rate. Med. Rec, N. Y, 1939, 150: 310.—Nyboer, J. Comparison of changes in cardiac and respiratory rhythms effected in the dog by changes in physiological conditions. Am. J. Physiol, 1933, 106: 204-24.—Strozzi, R. Osservazioni cUniche sul rapporto tra frequenza del polso, del respiro e temperatura patologica. Gazz. internaz. med. chir, 1930, 38: 547.—Sylla, A. Ver- langsamung der Herzschlagfolge durch tiefe Einatmung. Klin. Wschr, 1936, 15: 849-51.—Wallraff, J. Ueber die Ursache der Verlangsamung der Herzschlagfolge durch tiefe Einatmung, Ibid, 1937, 16: 1046.—Willem, V, & Willem, L. L'influence des mouvements respiratoires sur la pulsation cardiaque cbez les poissons teieosteehs. Bull. Acad. Belgique. 1926, 5. ser, 12: ---- Determination, and recording. See also Pulse; Sphygmography, &c. Iloas, E. P. The cardiotachorneter, an instrument to count the totality of heart beats over long periods of time. Arch. Int. M, 1928, 41: 403-14. Also Bull. N. York Acad. M, 1928, 2. ser, 4: 445-7.—Djourno, A. Sur la mesure instantanee de la frequence du pouls. Paris med, 1938, 109: 183.—Gillard, G., Hustin, A, & Rijlant, P. L'enregistrement continu de la frequence cardiaque moyenne chez I'homme. Arch, internat, physiol., Liege, 1939, 49: 199-208.—Jellinek, E. M., & Fertiif, J. W. A method for the estimation of average heart ratea HEART RATE 355 HEART RATE from cardiochronographic records. J. Psychol, Provincet, 1936 1: 193-9.—Kniazuk, M. A method for determining the heart rate of small animals. J. Lab. Clin. M, 1936-37, 22: 868-70.—Nemet, G, & Boas, E. P. Pulse rate studies with the pulse resonator. Am. Heart J, 1927-28, 3: 360-7.—Sontag, L W, & Richards, T. W. Technique for measuring heart rate. Monogr. Soc. Res. Child Develop, 1938, 3: No. 4, 7-9.— Unna, K, & Kniazuk, M. Application of the heart rate recorder to pharmacological research. Am. J. M. Sc, 1941, 201: 626. ---- Disorders. See also subheadings Bradycardia; Tachy- cardia; also Heart arrhythmia; Heart auricle, Flutter, &c; also under primary diseases as Thyrotoxicosis, &c. Bondurant, W. W, jr. The bradycardias and the tachy- cardias; bedside diagnosis and treatment. South. M. J, 1935, 28: 562-5.—Estape, F. de A. Diagn6stico y tratamiento de las taquicardias y bradicardias. Rev. med. Barcelona, 1927, 2. ser, 8: 596-612.—Henderson, Y, Haggard, H. W, & DoIIey, F. S. The efficiency of the heart, and the significance of rapid and slow pulse rates. Am. J. Physiol, 1927, 82: 512-24 — Jaeger, H. Ueber Herzbewegungen physiologischer und patho- logischer Natur; Brady- und Ta,chycardie. Med. Welt, 1940, 14: 1142-5. ---- fetal. See also Heart sound. Andersen, K. T. Der Einfluss der Entwicklungsstufe und der Temperatur auf die Pulsationsfrequenz des embryonalen Wirbeltierherzens. Arch. zool. ital, 1931-32, 16: 888-90 — Barry, A. Age changes in the pulsation frequency of the embryonic chick heart. J. Exp. Zool, 1940, 85: 157-70.— Bogue, J. Y. The heart rate of the developing chick. J. Exp. Biol, Lond, 1932, 9: 351-7.—Bondi, J. Stoning der Frequenz der kindlichen Herztone bei stehender Blase. Zbl Gyn, 1926, 50: 2624.—Corfield, C. R. The foetal heart beat; an obstetric experiment. Lancet, Lond, 1930, 1: 803.—Furtado, A. H. Rythmo cardio-fetal Rev. gyn. obst, Rio, 1937, 31: pt 2, 36-40.—Hartman, C. G, Squier, R. R, & Tinklepaugh, O. L. The fetal heart rate in the monkey (Macacus rhesus) Proc. Soc. Exp. Biol, N. Y, 1930-31,28:285-8.—Rech, W. Untersuchun- gen iiber die Herztatigkeit des Fetus; der Einfluss von Sauer- stoff und Kohlensaure auf die Frequenz des fetalen Herz- schlages. Arch. Gyn, Berl, 1931, 147: 82-94. ------ Die Wirkung des Kopfdruckes auf die Frequenz des fetalen Herz- schlages. Ibid, 1933, 154: 47-57.—Sontag, L. W., & Newbery, H. Normal variations of fetal heart rate during pregnancy. Am. J. Obst, 1940, 40: 449-52.—Sontag, L. W, & Richards, T. W. The relationship of fetal heart rate to bodily activity of the fetus. Monogr. Soc. Res. Child Develop, 1938, 3: No. 4, 30-4. ------ The relationship of fetal heart rate to certain normal physiological functions of the mother. Ibid, 35-41. ----- The fetal heart rate following the maternal breakfast. Ibid, 39-41. ------ Fetal heart rate following the adminis- tration of amyl nitrite to the mother. Ibid, 43-5. ------ Fetal heart rate following the administration of oxygen to the mother. Ibid, 45. ------ Experiments on modification of fetal heart rate; effects supposedly concomitant with stimula- tion arising external to the fetal and maternal bodies. Ibid, 49-60. ------ Interrelationships among factors of fetal reactivity and fetal heart rate. Ibid, 61-3. ---- fetal: Counting. De Lee, J. B. Counting the fetal heart beat. J. Am. M. Ass, 1927, 88: 1000.—Furtado, A. H. O rythmo cardio-fetal k luz da phonocardiographia. Rev. gyn. obst, Rio, 1938, 32: pt 2, 314-8.—Lonne, F. Wie kann man miitterliche und kind- liche Herzschlage bei gleicher oder annahernd gleicher Schlag- zahl unterscheiden? Zbl. Gyn, 1939, 63: 2656.—Mount, W. B. An electric timer as an aid in counting the fetal heart in the second stage of labor and in timing and spacing forceps tractions. Am. J. Obst, 1940, 39: 272-4.—Sontag, L. W, & Richards, T. W. The normal fetal heart rate. Monogr. Soc. Res. Child Develop, 1938, 3: No. 4, 12-29. ---- irregular. See Heart arrhythmia. ---- Physiology. See also Heartbeat, Regulation. Anrep, G. V, & Segall, H. N. The central and reflex regula- tion of the heart rate. J. Physiol, Lond, 1926-27, 61: 215- 31.—Bompiani, G. Sul significatofisio-patologico dellasostanza cronotropa nelle arterie. Arch. ital. anat. pat, 1934, 5: 489- 612.—Duomarco, J. Influence de la frequence cardiaque su* les rapports entre la pression moyenne arterielle et la pression moyenne intraventriculaire. C. rend. Soc. biol, 1937, 124: 592-4.—Giroux, L. Frequence du rythme cardiaque et duree du complexe ventriculaire. Rev. med. fr, 1932, 13: 351-5.— McCrea, F. D, & Wiggers, C. J. Rhythmic arterial expansion as a factor in the control of heart rate. Am. J. Physiol, 1933, 103: 417-31. Tachycardia. See also subheading Variation; also Heart auricle, Flutter; Heart muscle, Fibrillation; Heart ventricle, Fibrillation, &c. r,~A1,!?n* .?• A- Tachycardia. Clin. J, Lond, 1927, 56: 577-86. Also Glasgow M. J, 1927, 107: 74-84, 4 pl—Barrier, C- W. Tachycardia. Ann. Int. M, 1932, 5: 829-41.—BrUckner, Po, yeDer Tachykardie. Zschr. ges. phys. Ther, 1928, 35: JSio3-CamPbell. Tachycardia. Guy's Hosp. Gaz, Lond, 1928, 42: 374-9.—Cannon, W. B., & Lewis, J. T. The physi- ological maximum heart rate as an artefact. Am. J. Physiol 1927, 82: 67-74.—Dorevie, M. M, & Jakopovic, I. J. [Tachy- cardia] Voj. san. glasnik, 1935, 6: 205-25.—Hoffmann, A. Neueres iiber Tachykardie. Jahrkurs iirztl Fortbild, 1927 18: H. 2, 8-20.—Klinik (Zur) der Tachykardien. Aerztl. Prax, Wien, 1937, 11: 265-7.—Kremer, M. Tachycardia. Med. Press iden. Wien. Arch. inn. Mod, 1926, 13: 203-N2.—Livshilz. L. I. [The remaining working capacity of invalids with rheumatic valvular affections of the heart] Vrach. delo, 1934, 17: 597 602. Martin, A. T. Twenty years' observation of 1,438 children with rheumatic heart dis- ease; analvtic study following convalescent care from 1921 in 1941. J. Am. M. Ass, 1941, 117: 1663-70.—Nardoni, 1\ Importanza clinico-sociale dei postumi cardiaci della malattia reumatica. Gazz. internaz. med. chir, 1940, 49: No. 16, 3-8.— Page, R. ('. The rheumatic heart and preemplovment examina- tion. Med. Hull. (Standard Oil Co.) N. Y, 1939-41, 4: 251- 61.—Reid, W. I). The prognosis and treatment of rheutnaiic heart disease. Med. Press & Circ, Lond, 192S, n -er.. 12fi- 175-9. Also N. England M. J, 1928, 199: 139-13.-- Rheumatic heait disease a factor in victims' marriage plans. .1. Med Cincin.. 1940-4 1, 21: 518.—Rothschild, M. A, Kugel. M. A, & Gross, I, Incidence and significance of active infection in cases of rheumatic caxdiovalvular disease during the various age periods; a clinical and pathological studv. Am. Heart J , 1934, 19: 586-95.—Smith, F. M. The prognosis and treatment of rheumatic heart disease. Proc. Interst. Postgrad. M. Ass N America, 1938, 328-32.—Warner, E. ('. Rheumatic heart disease and its sequelae. Med. Press A: Circ, Lond, 1937, 194: 423-5.—Washburn, A. H. Rheumatic heart disease; factors in its prognosis. California West. M, 1927, 27: 781-6. ---- Radiography. Kuttner, A. G, & Reyersbach, G. The value of special radiologic procedures in detecting cardiac enlargement in chil- dren with rheumatic heart disease. Am. Heart J, 1939, 18: 213-27.— Panov, N. A. [Certain roentgenological data on rheumatic affections of the child's heart] Pediatria, Moskva, 1938, No. 5, 63-70—Taussig, H. B, & Goldenberg, M. Roentgenologic studies of the size of the heart in childhood; 3 different types of teleroentgenographic changes which occur in acute rheumatic fever. Am. Heart J, 1941, 21: 440-69. ---- recurrent. Morquio, L. Cardiopatia reumatica considerada curada; reaparicion despues de dif teria tratada con suero. Arch, pediat. Uruguay, 1936, 7: 308-11.— Piaggio Blanco, R, & Sciuto. J. A. Recidiva de una cardiopatia reumatismal en el curso de lf> enfermedad seriea. Arch. urug. med, 1940, 17: 414-8.— Schwartz, M, & Perchonock, S. Recurrent rheumatic heart disease without arthralgia. Med. Rec, N. Y, 1940, 152: 99-101. ---- Social service, and rehabilitation. Cohen, E. Social planning for children with rheumatic heart disease. Child, Wash, 1941, 5: 164-7.—Danielopolu, D, Dimitriu, C. C, & Tanasoca, T. Les rhumatismes et les affections de I'appareil circulatoire; programme d'organisation medico-sociale. Bull Acad. med. Roumanie, 1938, 3: 203- 93.—Hedley, O. F. Facilities in the United States for the special care of children with rheumatic heart disease. Pub. Health Rep, Wash, 1941, 56: 2321-41.—Kobes, R. T. Rheu- matic heart disease, in relation to public health nursing. Brit. J. Nurs, 1940, 88: 150. Also Pacific Coast J. Nurs, 1940, 36: 336-8.—McEwen, C. Rheumatic heart disease. Hosp. Social Serv, 1933, 28: Suppl. 2, 23-37.—Raven, M. O. Rheumatic cardiac affections; a plea for notification and institutional treatment. Lancet, Lond, 1922, 1: 1241.—Spekter, L. Serv- ices for the care of children with rheumatic heart disease. Connecticut Health Bull, 1940, 54: 238. ---- Statistics. Castilla, C. R, & Aguirre, R. S. La enfermedad de Bouillaud y las cardiopatias reumaticas y congenitas a traves de siete anos de funcionamiento del servicio. Sem. med, B. Air, 1939, 46: 663-8.—Clawson, B. J. Rheumatic heart disease; an analy- sis of 796 cases. Am. Heart J, 1940, 20: 454-74.—Cleland, J. B. Rheumatic heart lesions in 3,000 Australian post mortem examinations. Med. J. Australia, 1934, 2: 382-5.—Coombs, C. 1 he incidence of fatal rheumatic heart disease in Bristol, 1876- 1913. J. R. San. Inst, 1920-21, 40: 291. ------ Quelle est la proportion des maladies organiques du cnur dues au rhuma- oim% RfPP- Congr. internat. rhumat. (1932) 1934, 3. Congr, 383-5.—Davis, D., & Weiss, S. Rheumatic heart disease: incidence and role in the causation of death; a study of 5,215 consecutive necropsies. Am. Heart J, 1931, 7: 146-56. ----- Rheumatic heart disease; incidence and distribution of the age of death. Ibid, 1932, 8: 182-9.—Doolittle, S. E, & Tilden, 1. L. Rheumatic heart disease in Hawaii. Hawaii M. J, 1941, l: 7_1V T'\$eT' A- ' - Rheumatic heart disease in the county borough of Dewsbury. Brit. M. J, 1937, 2: 177— Hedley, 6. • Incidence of rheumatic heart disease among college students f.,™,United States. Pub. Health Rep, Wash., 1938. 53: 1635-47. ------ Rheumatic heart disease in Philadelphia hospitals; age, race, and sex distribution and interrelation of rheumatic fever, Sydenham's chorea, rheumatic heart disease, ifi?7Sni te| bacterial endocarditis. Ibid, 1940, 55: 1599; 1047-91.------ Rheumatic heart disease in Philadelphia hospitals; a study of 4,653 cases of rheumatic heart disease, rheumatic fever, Sydenham's chorea, and subacute bacterial endocarditis, involving 5,921 admissions to Philadelphia hospitals from January 1, 1930, to December 31, 1934; distribu- tion by locality of rheumatic conditions in Philadelphia. Ibid, '71 HEART RHEUMATISM HEART RHEUMATISM 1845-62. Also repr.—Levitt, A, & Jaskiewicz, S. J. Rheu- matic heart disease; an analysis of 110 cases. Am. J. Clin. Path, 1940, 10: 467-71.—Macera, J. M, Ruchelli, A. P, & Gaig.R. Encuesta sobre concurrencia de nifios reumaticos con v sin cardiopatias a los hospitales de la capital federal en el afio 1938. Dfa med, B. Air, 1939, 11: 864-7.—Maddox, K. Metropolitan and rural incidence and distribution of acute rheumatism and rheumatic heart disease in New South Wales. Med. J. Australia, 1937, 1: 425; 464. ------ Metropolitan and rural incidence and distribution of acute rheumatism and rheumatic heart disease in New South Wales; clinical aspects. Ibid, 499-504.—Nichol, E. S. Rheumatic heart disease in southern Florida; incidence and clinical notes. Am. Heart J.. 1933, 9: 63-71.—Perry, C. B, & Roberts, J. A. F. A study on the variability in the incidence of rheumatic heart disease within the city of Bristol. Brit. M. J, 1937, 2: Suppl, 154-8. Also repr.—Piaggio Blanco. R„ & Sciuto, J. A. Reumatismo cardiaco; estadistica sobre 1,500 enferm s ingresados al servicio clinico del Prof. Urioste. Arch. urug. med, 1940, 17: 60-2.— Rakov, H. L, & Taylor, J. S. Acute rheumatic heart disease in the aged; report of a case with unusual clinical manifestations. Am. Heart J, 1941, 21: 244-7.—Rathe, H. W. Rheumatic heart disease; with review of 95 cases. J. Iowa M. Soc, 1940, 30: 91-100.—Rheumatic heart disease in Philadelphia hospitals. J. Am. M. Ass, 1940, 115: 1803.—Stewart, W. C. Rheumatic fever and rheumatic heart disease in West Virginia. West Virginia M. J, 1936, 32: 420-4.—Survey (The) on rheumatic heart disease in Connecticut. Connecticut Health Bull, 1940, 54: 315.—Whiting, W. B. The incidence of rheumatic heart disease in Northern Texas. In Med. Papers (H. A. Christian Anniv. vol.) Bost, 1936, 125-8.—Wilson. W. J. The incidence of heart disease in rheumatic fever. J. Michigan M. Soc, 1931. 30: 765-70. ---- Surgery. See also Thyroidectomy; Tonsillectomy. Berlin, D. D, Blumgart, H. L. [et al] Treatment of angina pectoris and congestive failure by total ablation of the normal thyroid gland; with particular reference to surgical technique and summary of results in rheumatic heart disease. N. England J. M, 1934, 211: 863-70, pl—Meiks, L. T. The influence of tonsillectomy on the progress of rheumatic heart disease. J. Indiana M. Ass, 1940, 33: 666-70.—Willius, F. A. Clinic on rheumatic heart disease with mitral stenosis and insuificiency, recurrent exophthalmic goiter, congestive heart failure with regular rhvthm; thvroidectomv; course. Proc. Mavo Clin, 1936, 11: 86-90— Wilson, M.G., Lingg, C, & Croxford, G. Statistical studies bearing on problems in the classification of heart disease; tonsillectomy in its relation to the prevention of rheumatic heart disease. Am. Heart J, 1928-29, 4: 197-209. ---- Treatment. Bourne, G. The treatment of rheumatic carditis. Lancet. Lond, 1928, 2: 217-20.—BufTum, W. P. Management of convalescence in rheumatic heart disease. Rhode Island M. J, 1930, 13: 127-30.—Cirera Volta, R. Contribucion al trata- miento del reumatismo cardioarticular. Rev. med. Barcelona, 1934, 22: 100-9.—Coombs, C. F. The treatment of early cardiac rheumatism. J. R. Sari. Inst, 1926-27, 47: 199-204. Also Med. Press & Circ, Lond, 1926, n. ser, 122: 278-80. ----- The diagnosis and treatment of rheumatic heart disease in its early stages. Brit. M. J, 1930, 1: 227-30.—Cotton, T. F. The treatment of rheumatic carditis. Ibid, 1935, 1: 889-91. Also in Treat. Gen. Pract, 2. ed, Lond, 1938, 1: 156-62.— Fenn, G. K. Rheumatic heart in adult life; its recognition and management. Bull. Chicago M.-Soc, 1940-41, 43: 491 — Herrera Ramos, F. Trascendencia social del tratamiento cronico en las cardiopatias reumaVticas. Arch. urug. med, 1941, 19: 86-93.—Hochrein, M. Erkennung und Behandlung des rheumatischen Herzschadens. In Internat. arztl Fortbild, Brambach, 1935, 1. Kurs, 38-48.—Kuhl, A. F. The treatment of ambulatory rheumatic heart disease. Ohio M. J, 1935, 31: 331-5.—Lemant, J. Traitement du rhumatisme cardiaque. J. med. chir. Par, 1939, 110: 526-32.—Luginbuhl, C. B. The treatment of rheumatic heart disease. J. Iowa M. Soc, 1936, 26: 513-6.—Lundy, C. J. The treatment of rheumatic heart disease. IUinois M. J, 1935, 67: 251-5.—Lutembacher, R. Treatment of the cardiopathies of rheumatic origin. Med. Press & Circ, Lond, 1935, 429-37.—Management (The) of early cases of rheumatic heart disease. Med. J. Australia, 1937, 2: 676-8.—Parsons-Smith, B. The treatment of a case of rheumatic heart disease. Practitioner, Lond, 1937, 138: 594- 602.—Partes, A. [Significance of rheuma therapy from the viewpoint of heart diseases] Gyogy&szat, 1937, 77: 625-30.— Pichon, E. Le rhumatisme cardiaque et son traitement. Medecine, Par, 1926-27, 8: Suppl, 3-3-1.—Robey, W. H. Treatment of rheumatic heart disease. N. England .1 M, 1932, 207: 533.—Roth, I. R. The treatment of rheumatic heart disease in children and adults. Med. Rec, N. Y, 1941, 153: 128-32.—Sutton, I, P. The management of rheumatic heart disease. Med. Clin. N. America, 1936-37, 20: 961^72 — Swift, H. F. R heumatic heart disease; pathogenesis and etiology in their relation to therapy and prophylaxis. Medicine, Bait, 1940, 19: 417-40.—Thompson, E. The treatment of rheumatic heart disease. Nebraska M. J, 1940, 25: 58.—Turnbull, H. H. Treatment of the cardiac affections of acute rheumatism. Austral. M. J, 1911, 16: 152-63 [Discussion] 185-9. ---- Treatment: Balneo-, creno- and climato- therapy. Bernath-Partos, A. [Rheumatism and heart diseases from the view-point of balneological therapy] Bratisl. lek. listy, 1939, 19: 226-31.—Bona, G. B. I successi della balneoterapia solforosa (Salice Terme) nei cardiopazienti reumatici. Med. lavoro, 1935, 26: 372-5.—Cmunt, E. Indication for the treat- ment of rheumatic diseases of the heart with sulphur saline waters. Rapp. Congr. internat. rhumat. (1934) 1936, 4. Cono-r, 351-5.—Drjagin, K. A, & Portsova, P. J. Methods of mud treatment in rheumatism complicated by heart disease. Ibid, 317-22.—Filinkova, P. P. [Mean arterial pressure in cardio- rheumatic children from the effect of climato-balneological factors of the health resort Sochi-Matsesta] Vopr. kurort, 1941, No. 3, 49-54—Gvatseladze, L. S. [Treatment of cardio- rheumatic children at the health resort Sochi-Matsesta] Ibid, 29-36.—Lieven, A. Ueber Balneotherapie bei herz- und gefasskranken Rheumatikern. Zschr. wiss. Baderk, 1927-28, 2: 41-50.—Lowy, S. Herz und Balneotherapie beim Rheu- matiker. Med. Klin, Berl, 1930, 26: I860.—Migliorati, M. La crenoterapia di Sirmione negli adolescenti cardiopatie reumatismati. Riv. idr. clim, 1932, 48: 107-10.—Piatot, A. Le rhumatisme cardiaque evolutif est-il une contre-indication des cures thermales'.' Paris med, 1927, 63: 276-83. ------ Le rhumatisme cardiaque et son traitement hvdromineral J. med. chir. Par, 1930, 101: 240-8— Scheinkman, S. S. [Electrocardiographic variations in rheumatic children during treatment with sulphurous baths] Pediatria, Moskva, 1940, No. 9, 35-7.—Valedinskij, I. Les indications du traitement par les eaux hydrosulfutees fortes des affections cardio-vasculaires chez les rhumatisants. Rapp. Congr. internat. rhumat. (1934) 1936, 4. Congr, 347-50. ---- Treatment: Biological measures. Barach, J. H. Acute rheumatic heart disease treated with streptococcus antitoxin (scarlet fever serum) J. Am. M. Ass, 1927, 88: 1882.—Laubry, C, & Jaubert, A. Sur l'interet et la technique des premunitions antimicrobiennes au cours des cardiopathies rhumatismales. Bull. Soc. med. hop. Paris, 1931. 3. ser, 47: 1020-6.—Le Gendre, P. Deux cas de cardiopathies rhumatismales aigues ttes graves, traitees avec succds par le serum de G. Rosenthal. Ibid, 1910, 3. ser, 29: 863-6. Also Tribune med. Par, 1910, n. ser, 43: 599.—Perry, C. B. Rheumatic heart disease and vitamin C. Lancet, Lond, 1935, 2: 426.—Rosenberg, L. C. The effect of repeated blood trans- fusions upon the erythrocyte sedimentation rate in rheumatic heart disease. J. Pediat, S. Louis, 1937, 10: 648-55.—Small, J. C. The treatment of rheumatic carditis with aqueous extracts of streptococci. J. Lab. Clin. M, 1934, 19: 695-705.—Stroud, W, Bromer, A. W, & Gallagher, J. R. Intravenous vaccine in rheumatic cardio-vascular disease. Tr. Ass. Am. Physicians, 1932, 47: 29-40. ---- Treatment: Methods. Calvet, E. S. A. *Etat actuel de la thera- peutique iodee dans les cardiopathies rhumatis- males. 61p. 24cm. Par., 1938. Bast, O. A. Spiroform in Rheumatismusfallen mit Herz- komplikationen. N. Yorker med. Mschr, 1908, 20: 169.— Bruenn, H. G. Effect of atropine on impaired auriculo- ventricular conduction in rheumatic fever. Proc. Soc. Exp. Biol, N. V, 1934-35, 32: 562-4.—Cirera Volta, R. Contribu- tion au traitement du rhumatisme cardio-articulaire. Rapp. Congr. internat. rhumat. (1934) 1936, 4. Congr, 227-35 — Davis H. C. Acute rheumatic heart disease apparently cured by sulfanilamide. West Virginia M. J, 1942, 38: 58-63.— Gunn, W. Intravenous injections of gentian violet in the treatment of rheumatic carditis. Lancet, Lond, 1927, 1: 125-7.—Malamani, V. Sopra un singolare comportamento ecgrafico dopo digital- in soggetto con cardiopatia reumatica. Gazz. osp, 1939, 60: 683-90.—Malkin, S. I, & Toumacheva, I). G. Le traitement des cardiopathies rhumatismales par la therapie desensibilisatrice sous forme d'injections intraveineuses d'hyposulfite de soude. Rev. med. Par, 1935, 52: 390-7 — Mascheroni, H, & Marquez, J. F. Ensayo de alcoholoterapia en el reumatismo cardiaco evolutivo. Sem. med, B. Air, 1934, 41: 1759-63.—Nixon, J. A. Rigid rest in rheumatic carditis. Bristol Med. Chir. J, 1926, 43: 96-103.—Paul, M, & Babitz, H. Heilerfolge bei septischer Endo- und Pankarditis rheumatischer Genese durch Kalomel. Miinch. med. Wschr, 1932, 79: 25.— Roberts, H. A. The homoeopathic treatment of metastases of rheumatic fever in relation to the heart. Homoeop. Rec, 1931, 46: 800-7.—Slonim, M. I. [Active or expectant therapy in rheumatism of the heart] Sovet. med, 1937, No. 3, 4-6.— Weiss, S, & Ellis, L. B. Circulatory measurements in patients with rheumatic heart disease before and after the administration of digitahs. J. CUn. Invest, 1930, 8: 435-65. ---- Treatment: Physiotherapy. Albov. N. A. [Reflectory vegetative physiotherapy in rheumatic diseases of the heart] Sovet. vrach. J, 1936, 1: 1701-5.—Levy, R. L, & Golden, R. Roentgen ray therapy in rheumatic heart disease. Proc. Soc. Exp. Biol, N. Y, 1925-26, 23:351-3. ------ Some effects of Roentgen irradiation of the heart in rheumatic carditis. Am. J. Roentg, 1927, 18: 103-10. HEART RHEUMATISM 3 72 HEART SAC Also Tr. Ass. Am. Physicians, 1928, 43: 230-3. Also Am. Heart J, 1928-29, 4: 127-44. ------ Roentgen therapy of rheu- matic heart di-ease; a review of 6 years' experience. Am. J. Roentg., 1933, 29: 79-82. ------ Roentgen therapy of active rheumatic heart disease. Am. J. M. Sc, 1937, 194: 597-601 — Proger, S. H.. & Korth, C. Effect of UgUt muscular training on patients with heart disease; rheumatic heart disease; changes at rest and during exercise. Arch. Int. M, 1935, 55: 204-26.— Sutton, I, P.. A- Dodge, K. G. The effect of fever therapy on rheumatic eaiditis associated with chorea, with a preliminary report on fever therapy in rheumatic carditis without chorea. J. Pediat, S. Louis, 1935, 6: 494-511. ---- Treatment: Salicylate. Bernardi, A. J. Reumatismo cardioarticular; tratamiento por la soluci6n poUsahcilada isotenica por via rectal. Dia med, B. Air, 1940, 12: 735.—Bullrich, R. A. La soluci6n polisalici- lada isotenica por via rectal en el tratamiento del reumatismo cardio-articular. Accion med, B. Air, 1939, 9: 385. Also Dfa med, B. Air.. 1939, 11: 1097. Also Dfa med. urug, 1939-40, 7: 2.—Douiner, E. L'extrait thyroidien associe au sahcylate de soude dans le traitement du rhumatisme cardiaque evolutif. Gaz. hop, 1926, 99: 805-7.—Dumas, A. Tachycardie ventricu- laire febrile imputable au rhumatisme et ayant tetrocede k la suite du traitement saticyle. J. med. Lyon, 1939, 20: 527-30.— G. B, R. El metodo salicilo-alcaUno masivo en el tratamiento del reumatismo cardio-articular. Dia med, B. Air, 1939, 11: 1034.—Giroux, L. Le traitement sahcyie et les cardiopathies rhumatismales. Lvolut. ther, 1926, 7: 235-9.—Levy, R. L, & Turner, K. B. Variations in auriculoventricular conduction time in rheumatic eaiditis with salicvlate therapy. Proc. Soc. Exp. Biol, N. Y, 1927-28, 25: 64.—Marchal, G. La medica- tion salievlo-souftee dans le rhumatisme cardiaque. Rev. med. Par, 1934, 51: 37-44.—Theodoresco, B, & Aberfeld, N. Maladie de Bouillaud abarticulaire, avec dissociation auriculo- ventriculaire complete, juguiee par le traitement sahcyie ptecoce. Bull. Soc. med. hop. Paris, 1937, 3. ser, 53: 1505-9 — Vladysik, M. M. [Rheumatic carditis and decompensation of the heart; treatment with salicylates exclusively] Sovet. med, 1937, No. 3, 17-9. HEART SAC [Pericardium] See also Heart; also in 3. ser. Pericardium. Hoffmann, J. M., & Frank, G. F. *Exerci- tatio medica de pericardio, atque experimentis et observationibus novissimis circa id habitis. 30p. 19cm. Altdorf [1690] Wallraff, J. *Der menschliche Herzbeutel, sein Bau und seine Bedeutung fiir den Kreislauf [Breslau] p.355-429. 23cm. Lpz., 1937. Also Morph. Jahrb, 1937, 80: Davis, C. I, Early states of the formation of the human pericardial caiity. Anat. Rec, 1926-27, 35: 9.—Delattre, A. Le peiicarile du bile veineux du coeur. J. fe. med. LiUe, 1921, 39: 357; 373.—Dentiii. L. Struttura dei legamenti del peri- cardio. Boll Soc. ital biol sper, 1934, 9: 753.—Elliott, R. A contribution to the development of the pericardium. Am. J. Anat, 1931, 48: 355-90.— Jineberg, M. H. The estimation of pericardial capacity in Uving dogs. Am. J. Physiol, 1935, 113: 42.—Gaver, F. van, & Stephan, P. Sur la nature du corps flottant du pericarde de certaines ascidies. C. rend. Soc. biol, 1907, 62: 554.—Goodrich, E. S. On the development of the pericardiaco-peritoneal canals in selachians. J. Anat, Lond, 1918-19, 53: 1-13.—Hjelmman, G. [Disposition of the peri- cardium, with regard to its foldings and to the sinus trans- versus ].ericaidii] Fin. liik. sail hand, 1928, 70: 360-71 — Hurlbutt, I. R, jr. Peri kardies; a treatise on the heart from the Hipi ocrutio Corpus; introduction and translation. Bull. Hist. M, 1939, 7: 1104-13.—Nauck, E. T. Die Beziehungen des Herzbeutels zum Zwerchfell Zool. Anz, 1938, 124: 13-22.—Fopa, G. T, & Luoinescu, E. La mecanostructure du pericarde. C. rend. Soc. biol, 1930, 104: 445. Also J. Anat, Lond, 1932, 67: 78-107.—Salmon, M, & Dor, J. Les arteres du pericarde. Arch, anat, Strasb, 1939, 27: 171-202.—Scatizzi, I. L'organo Unfomieloide pericardico dello storione. Arch. zool. ital, 1933, 18: 1-26.—Seara, P. Seno transverso de Lheile; revision anatomica. Prensa med. argent, 1939, 26: 696-701.—Sudzuki, M. Leber die Perikardial- fliissigkeit des Seiwals. Tohoku J. Exp. M, 1921, 2: 355 — Torehi, G. La rappresentazione radiografica del legamento costopericardico (di Luschka) Ann. radiol, Bologna, 1934, 8: 508-15.—lurr.er, C. L. Pericardial sac, trophotaeniae, and alimentary tract in embrvos of goodeid fishes. J. Morph, 1940, 67: 271-89, 3 pl—Walln.fi, J. Die konstruktive Form des menschlichen Herzbeutels; vorlaufige Mitteilung. Verh. Anat. Ges, 1934, 42: 68-80.------Experimentelle Lnter- suchungen uber die Dehnbarkeit und iiber die Wanddicke des menschlichen Herzbeutels. Ibid, 1936, 43: 171-82. ------ Leber den Bau und die KreislaufTunktionen des menschhchen Herzbeutels. Klin. W schr, 1937, lb: 1665-9.—Yanovski. V. L. [Oesophageal curvature of the pericardium, its explanation and significance] \rach. gaz, 1910, 17: 47; 92; 125. ---- Abnormity. Riedel, G. * Angeborener Defckt des Herz- beutels bei einem Sporllerherzen. 30p. 21cm. Wiirzb., 1938. Beck, C. S. Congenital deficiency of the pericardium; the function of the. pericardium. Arch. Surg, 1931. 22: 282-8. Also repr.—Beyer, R. Leber angeborene Herzbeuteldefektc. Zschr. Kreislaufforsch.. 1938, 30: 411 7. Browne, T. G. Anomalv of the pericardium in a bitch. \et. J, Lond, 1924, 80: 316-8.—Egbert, D. S, & Little, S. Congenital pericardial deficiency with other anomalies; report of a case with necropsy findings. Yale J. Biol, 1935-36, 8: 19-22.—Grant. R. T. Congenital pericardial deficiency; an observation on the func- tion of the pericardium. Heart, Lond, 1926, 13: 371-9. - Hesselgren. [A case of congenital pericardium with abnormal action of the heart] Hygiea, Stockh, 1919, 81: 642-7.— Kadin, M. Congenital deficiency of the pericardium. J. Michigan M. Soc, 1939, 38: 503-6. Also repr.—Krembs, J. Kongenitale Herzbeutelspalte (Fissura pericardii) bei einem Kalb. Munch, tierarztl. Wschr, 1937, 88: 162.—Osgood, R, & Spector, B. Defective pericardial sac and interatrial septum and atresia of pulmonic orifice. Am. J. Dis. Child, 1941, 61: 1028-33.—Southworth, H, & Stevenson, C. S. Congenital defects of the pericardium. Arch. Int. M, 1938, 61: 223-40.— Watt, J. C. A rare congenital deficiency of the pericardium. Arch. Surg, 1931, 23: 996-1006. ---- Absence. Buck, M. *Die physiologische Bedeutung und die Folgen eines Fehlens des Herzbeutels [Munchen] 31p. 22cm. Wiirzb., 1938. Barsoum, H. Absence of pericardium. Brit. M. J, 1935, 2: 666.—Brown, F. V. B. A case of congenital absence of peri- cardium and left half of diaphragm. N. Zealand M. J, 1921, 20: 191-3.—Ladd, W. E. Congenital absence of the peri- cardium; with report of a case. Tr. N. England Surg. Soc, 1935, 18: 230-42. Also N. England J. M, 1936, 214: 183-7 — Nicoli, L. Assenza del sacco pericardico. Boll. Soc. med. chir, Pavia, 1929, n. ser, 4: 499-513, pl—Schlotthauer, C. F, & Stalker, L. K. Absence of the pericardium in dogs; report of 2 cases. J. Am. Vet. M. Ass, 1936, 88: 755. ---- Absorption, and pharmacology. Baltaceanu, G, Vasiliu, C, & Noyac, A. Absorption de 1'adrenaline et de la nicotine par le pericarde. C. rend. Soc. biol, 1936, 123: 833-6. ------ Absorption de la digitaline et de l'ouabaine par le pericarde. Ibid, 837-9.—Bijlsman', U. G, & Le Heux, J. W. Die Bedeutung des Pericards; Pharmakologie. Acta brevia neerl, 1932, 2: 163.—Drinker, C. K, & Field, M. E. Absorption from the pericardial cavity. J. Exp. M, 1931, 53: 143-50, pl. Also repr.—Herzog, R. S. Electrocardiographic studies of chemical pericardial irritation. Proc. Soc. Exp. Biol, N. Y, 1934, 32: 230-5—Horio, S. Experimental study of resorption from the pericardial cavity; resorption of solution, particles and blood. Jap. J. M. Sc, 1934-36, 4: Surg. &c, 243-5.—Stewart, H. J, Crane, N. F, & Deitrick, J. E. Absorption from the pericardial cavity in man. Am. Heart J, 1938, 16: 198-202. ---- Calcification. See also subheading Pericarditis, adhesive: Calcification. Bartels, E. C. Calcification of pericardium. Minnesota M, 1933, 16: 205-7.—Beck, C. S. A physiological concept of pericardial disorders; report of a case of chronic intraperi- cardial pressure due to calcification of the pericardium treated by operation. Internat. CUn, 1934, 44. ser, 3: 174-89, 5 pl— Bonomini, B. Calcificazioni pericardiche in bambino. Radiol. med, Milano, 1936, 23: 859-65.—Breton, A. Les calcifications du pericarde. Gaz. hop, 1937, 110: 45; 77-9.—Codet, P. H, & Bonte, G. Deux cas de calcification du pericarde. Bull Soc. radiol. med. France, 1936, 24: 134-9.—Crimm, P. D, McDon- ald, J. D, & Cookson, H. N. Calcification of pericardium. J. Indiana M. Ass, 1940, 33: 415-8.—Desbuquois, G. Deux nouveau cas de calcifications du p6ricarde. Bull Soc. med. hop. Paris, 1936, 3. ser, 52: 71-6.—Desplats, R, & D'Hour, H. Calcification du pericarde. J. radiol. electr, 1929, 13: 45.— Drummond, C; I. Calcification of pericardium; edema of head and neck, a symptom. Northwest M, 1940, 39: 217.—Duncan, E. Calcification of the pericardium. Tr. Glasgow Path. CUn. Soc, 1899-1900, 8: 53.—Fischer, R. Ventrikulare paroxys- male Tachykardie in Salven bei Perikardverkalkung. Mitt. Ges. inn. Med. Wien, 1935, 34: 91. ------& Wasserbrenner, K. Paroxysmale ventrikulare Tachvkardie bei Perikardver- kalkung. Med. KUn, Berl, 1935, 31: 1171-4.—Forman. F. A case of calcified pericardium. J. M. Ass. S. Africa, 1931, 5: 271-4.—Galifi, L. Sulle calcificazioni del pericardio. Radiol. med, Milano, 1937, 24: 326-34.—Gonzalez Sabathie, L. El ruido protodiastolic© de la calcificaci6n del pericardio. In his Temas cardiol, B. Air, 1939, 2: 83-95.—Jones, H. W, & Roberts, R. E. Calcification of the pericardium. Brit. J. HEART SAC 373 HEART SAC Radiol, 1927, 32: B. I. R. Sect, 167, pl.—Jourdain & Bastenie Ln cas de calcification du pericarde. Bruxelles med, 1933-34 14- 1031.—Le Goff. Calcification du pericarde. Bull. Sor radiol. med. France, 1927, 15: 329-31.—Lian, C. Diagnostii clinique de la calcification du pericarde. Bull. Soc. med. hop. Paris, 1934, 3. ser, 50: 85. ------ Marchal, M., & Pautrat, J. Ln signe clinique de la calcification du p6ricarde la vibrance pericardique protodiastolique. Ibid, 1933, 3. ser., 49: 20-8.—Lucas, J. J. S. Pericardial calcification. Brit M. J, 1907, 2: 1404.—Lyons, C. G, & Wiltrakis, G. A. Calci fication of the pericardium. Med. Bull. Veterans Admin.. 1936-37, 13: 297-300.—Martini, T, Joselevich, M. [et al] Calcificaci6n del pericardio. Sem. med, B. Air, 1936, 43: 1183-90.—Michelazzi, A. Sopra un raro caso di ossificazione pressoche completa del pericardio. Lav. Congr. med. int., Roma (1905) 1906, 15: 420.—Rummert, O. Leber Peri- kardverkalkungen. Fortsch. Roentgenstrahl, 1937, 55: 241- 53.—Schultz. Perikardverkalkung nach Schussverletzung. Rontgenpraxis, 1935, 7: 778.—Soleil, G. Un cas de calcifica- tion pleuro-pericardique d'origine traumatique. Bull. Soc. radiol. med. France, 1936, 24: 421-5. Also Gaz. med. France, 1937, 44: radiol, 207.—Stott, A. Calcified pericardium. Proc. R. Soc. M, Lond, 1934-35. 28: 1186.—Vilvandre, G. E. A case of calcification of the pericardium. Lancet, Lond, 1930, 1: 564-6, pl.—Youmans, J. B. Calcification of the peri- cardium; a cUnical problem; with report of 2 additional cases diagnosed during Ufe. Ann. Clin. M, 1925-26, 4: 1032-44. ---- Cancer. See also subheadings Endothelioma; Sarcoma. Abdulkadir. Karzinomatose Perikarditis. Wien. med. Wschr, 1931, 81: 151.—Campagna, M, & Hauser, G. H. A malignant condition of the pericardium. J. Am. M. Ass, 1928, 90: 1362-4.—Heninger, B. R. CUnical aspects of peri- cardial metastasis. Ann. Int. M, 1934, 7: 1359-69.—Kohl- meier, W, & Knirsch, E. Leber ein primares Karzinom des Herzbeutels. Wien. kUn. Wschr, 1935, 48: 714-6.—Satke, O, & Salzer, G. Ueber ein primares Carcinom des Herz- beutels. Virchows Arch, 1932, 284: 632-9.—Scheidegger, S. MaUgnes Hamangioblastom des Perikards (Beitrag zur Frage der Deckzellengeschwulste) Frankf. Zschr. Path, 1937-38, 51: 286-309.—Seldam, R. E. J. ten [Primarv carcinoma of the pericardium] Geneesk. tschr. Ned. Indie, 1936, 76: 2703-9.— Spangenberg, J. J, Marquez, J. F, Marano, A. EpiteUoma bronquial con metastasis pericardica. Rev. As. med. argent, 1937, 50: 60-6.—Willius, F. A. CUnic on malignancy in the pericardium; phenomena attending rapidly accumulating peri- cardial effusion; course of the disease and postmortem findings. Proc. Mayo CUn, 1934, 9: 650-3. ----• Cyst. See also subheading Diverticulum. Eliaschewitsch, P. A. Ein Fall von Perikardcyste. Vir- chows Arch, 1928-29, 270: 868-72.—Haas, L. [Cysta peri- cardii] Orv. hetil, 1938, 82: 256.—Nossen, H. Tod unter dem BUde der LungenemboUe durch Zyste im Perikard. Deut. med. Wschr, 1925, 51: 1150.—Tracy, F. E. Calcified cyst of the pericardium. Connecticut M. J, 1942, 6: 103-6.— Wright, A. D. Calcified cyst of pericardium. Tr. M. Soc. London, 1934,57:133.—Yater, W. M. Cyst of the pericardium. Am. Heart J, 1931, 6: 710-2. ---- Disease. See also Heart, Compression. Schneider, E. *Beitrag zur Kenntnis und Ursache der Herztamponade bei unseren Haus- tieren. 46p. 8? Lpz., 1933. Balzer, F. Anevrysmes miUaires du pericarde; lesions tuber- culeuses chez un syphiUtique. Syphilis, Par, 1905, 3: 909.— Basabe, H. Semiologfa del periocardio; el sindrome de la estrechez auricular derecha. Sem. m6d, B. Air, 1937, 44: 1281-5.—Battro, A. Tratamiento de los procesos pericardicos. In Bibl. ter. Ter. clin. (Cardini, C, & Beretervide, J. J.) B. Air, 1941, 1: 460-72.—Beck, C. S. Two cardiac compression triads. J. Am. M. Ass, 1935, 104: 714-6. ------ Compres- sion of the heart. Radiology, 1941, 37: 47-53.—Burwell, C. S. Diseases of the pericardium. In Modern Med. Ther. (Barr, D. P.) Bait, 1940, 3: 2580-93.—Cramer, H, Stehr, L. Ergeb- nisse der Kymographie bei Herzbeutelaffektionen. Fortsch. Rontgenstrahl, 1937, 56: 404-18. ------ Rontgenkymo- graphie bei Perikarderkrankungen. Ibid, Kongrh, 19.— Goncharov, P. P. [Analysis of manifestations in compression of the heart] Arkh. biol. nauk, 1933, 33: 787-98.—Kienbock, R, & Weiss, K. Leber geschwulstige und zystische Erkran- kungen am Herzbeutel Wien. Arch. inn. Med, 1932, 23: 155-72.—Lewin, B. Der Tod durch Herzbeuteltamponade in versicherungsrechtlicher und gerichtsarztlicher Beziehung. Deut. Zschr. gerichtl Med, 1933, 21: 34-56.—Lifshitz, L. a., & Margolina, M. I. [Clinical investigation of the various forms of affections of the pericardium] Vrach. delo, 193S, 20: 659- 64.—McPhedr<.n, A. Diseases of the pericardium, ln Mod. Med. (Osier) Phila, 1908, 4: 41-89.—Ostrowski, W, & Pine, I. [Electrocardiographic changes in heart tamponade] Polskn- arch. med. wewn, 193/, 15: 1142-66. Also Zschr. ges. exp. Mud, 1937, 101: 465-76.—Prati, M. Sul meccanismo ui morte pel ramponamento pericardico; ricerche sperimentaU. Riv. pat. *per„ 1926, 1: 149; 501, 2 pl—Reissinger, H. Versuche iiber ferztamponade. Zschr. Biol, 1926-27, 85: 482-98.—Roberts, S. T. Diseases of the pericardium. In Syst. Med. (Allbutt & tolleston) Lond, 1909, 6: 26-104.—Schwab, E. H, & Herr- nann, G. Alterations of the electrocardiogram in diseases of ijie pericardium. Arch. Int. M, 1935, 55: 917-41.—Smith, K. i. The diagnosis and treatment of acute pericardial disease. Practitioner, Lond, 1935, 134: 194-204. ------ Pericardium liseases. In Brit. Encycl. M. Pract. (Rolleston, H.) Lond, 1937,6:256-76.—Warburg, E. [On constrictio cordis] Ugeskr. Iseger, 1939, 101: 433^1.—Willius, F. A. Diseases of the pericardium. In his Card. Clinics, S. Louis, 1941, 30-46. ---- Diverticulum. See also subheading Pericarditis, exudative. Almeida Prado, A. de. Aneurisma do seio de Valsalva ou diverticulo do pericardio? Ann. Fac. med. S. Paulo, 1939, 15: 269-300, 2 pl. Also Presse med, 1940, 48: 143-7.—Arrillaga, F. C, Donovan, C, & Taquini, A. C. Diverticule du pericarde. Arch. mal. cceur, 1938, 31: 235-43. Also Rev. argent, card, 1938, 5: 49-57.—Cushing, E. H. Diverticulum of the peri- cardium. Arch. Int. M, 1937, 59: 56-64. —----& Moritz, A. Diverticulum of the pericardium; further data showing presence of extrathoracic abscess. Ibid, 1937, 60: 482-5.—Ernst, F. Ein Beitrag zum entzundlichen Herzbeuteldivertikel. Rontgen- praxis, 1935, 7: 754-9.—Eschbach. H. Das chronisch-ent- ziindUche Perikarddivertikel Deut. med. Wschr, 1939, 65: 840; 878.—Fossati, F. Ernie, diverticoli ed essudati saccati del pericardio; sintomatologia e diagnosi differenziale radiologica. Radiol, med, Milano, 1940, 27: 343-65. :------ Schwierig- keiten, Ungewissheiten und Fehlerquellen in der radiologischen Diagnose der Perikarddivertikel. Radiol. Chn, Basel, 1941, 10: 280-8. ------ & Cossali, C. DiverticoU e cisti del peri- cardio; rassegna critica e studio clinico-radiologico. Arch, pat, Bologna, 1940, 20: 383-433.—Freedman, E. Inflammatory diverticula of the pericardium (encapsulated pericardial effusion) Am. J. Roentg, 1937, 37: 733-8.—Galtung Hansen, O. [Diverticulum of the pericardium] Nord. med, 1939, 3: 2787-9.—Gershkovich, I. O. [Diverticulum of the pericardium] KUn. med, Moskva, 1938, 16: 1426-28, pl—Grabowski, W. Zur Kasuistik der Perikarddivertikel. Zbl. allg. Path, 1926, 37: 388-91.—Haas, L. Diverticulum pericardii. Acta radiol, Stockh, 1939, 20: 228-34. Also Orv. hetil, 1939, 83: meU, 122-4.—Hentschel, A. M. Die Entwicklung eines Perikard- divertikels. Rontgenpraxis, 1939, 11: 590.—Jaderholm, K. B. Leber Perikarddivertikel. Acta chir. scand, 1932, 71: 517- 23, 2 pl.—Jansson, G. Beitrag zur Rontgendiagnostik beim Perikarddivertikel (respiratorische Formveranderung des Mittelschattens) Acta radiol, Stockh, 1931, 12: 50-8, 2 pl.—Kedrovsky, V. V. [Cases of diverticula of the pericardium] Vrach. delo, 1929, 12: 9-11.—Kienbock, R, & Weiss, K. Leber das entzundliche Perikard-Divertikel Fortsch. Ront- genstrahl, 1929, 40: 389-418. —---- Ueber das entzund- liche Herzbeuteldivertikel Ibid, 1934, 50: 442-5.—Laubry, C, & Heim de Balsac, R. Diverticule du pericarde. Arch. mal. cceur, 1938, 31: 432-6.—Len&gre, J, Heim de Balsac, R, & Lubas, F. Ln nouveau cas de diverticule du pericarde. Ibid, 1138-41.—Mamolat, A. S. [Diverticulum of the pericardium] In Rec. trav. M. F. Melnikov-Razvedenkov, Kiev, 1939, 393-9.—Nauta, J. H. [Encapsulated pericardial exudate; pericardial cyst, pericardial diverticulum] Ned. tschr. geneesk, 1939, 83: 3904-10, pl— Neprjachin, G. G. Zur Frage uber das perikardiale Divertikel Zbl. allg. Path, 1927, 39: 548-51.— Paisseau, G, & Weill, J. Diverticule du pericarde. Bud. Soc. med. hop. Paris, 1938, 3. ser, 54: pt 2, 1319-23.—Reit^n, H. Beitrag zur Rontgendiagnose der Perikarddivertikel und der abgesackten Perikardexsudate. Fortsch. Rontgenstrahl, 1938, 58: 195-213.—Rizzi, I. Cisti e diverticoU del pericardio. Cuore & circol, 1935, 19: 539-70.—We3sler, H, & Fried, J. Encapsulated pericardial effusion. Am. J. M. Sc, 1928, 175: 331-6, 4 pl.—Ypsilanti, H. Leber einen FaU von echtem Perikarddivertikel Zbl. allg. Path, 1930-31, 50: 417-20 — Zeitlin, A. A. [Diverticulum of the pericardium and capsular pericardial exudate] KUn. med, Moskva, 1940, 18: No. 7, 112-6. ---- Echinococcosis. Deve, F. Echinococcose pericardique expSrimentale. C. rend. Soc. biol, 1931, lOd: 639-41— Gerbut, M. I. lE^hino- coccus of the pericardium] Nov. khir. arch, 1940, it: 267- 70.—Kalf, M. I. [Echinococcus in the region of the peri- cardium] Vest, rentg, 1930, »: 257-9.—Neri, V. Eohino- coccosi pericardica. Gior. venet. sc. med, 1939, 13: 844-51.— Opokin, A, & Kolju, K. Zur Diagnostik, Klinik und opera- tiven Behandlung des Herzbeutelechinococcus. Arch. klin. Chir, 1934-35, lal: 696-706. ---- Endothelioma. Bail, W. Ein Fall von CoelothaUom des Herzbeutels. Frankf. Zschr. Path, 1938, 52: 14J-L—Did, J. C. Endo- thelioma of the pericardium. J. Path. Bact, Lond, 1938, 47: t3-6, 3 pl. —Fernandez buna, D, & L.ui.:»id-., R. L Endo- lelioma primitivo del pericardio. Re/. As. med. argent, 1939, id: 149-52.—.v.cDon Id, o, jr. Primary endothelioma of the pericardium. J. Path. Bact, Load, 1936, 43: 13/-41, 2 pl— iNatuli, C. Un caso di endotehoma prim.tivo del pericardio. HEART SAC 374 HEART SAC Cuore & circol, 1926, 10: 195-207.- Salomon, S. Endo- theliom am Herzbeutel eines Pferdes. Perl, lieioztl. Wschr.. 1934. 50: 51V- Sevastianov, I.. & Vinogradov, S. [Primary endothelioma of pericardium] M >«k. med. J, 1927, 7: No. 6, 66-70. Also Zschr. khn. Med. 1 28, 108: 560-5.—Stoerk, H. Un cas d'endotheiiome developpe sur le pericarde. Ann. anat. path. Par, 1939, 16: 660-5. ---- Fistula. Goncharov, P. P. [Chronic pericardial fistula] Arkh. biol. nauk, 1933, 33: 799-802.—Landt, H, & Friedman, R. The dynamic consequences of an auriculopericardial fistula. J. Lab. CUn. M, 1934, 19: 1091-4. ---- Foreign, and loose body [including para- sites] See also subheadings Injury; Pericarditis, traumatic. Braul, J. [Case history of foreign bodies found in peri- cardium through perforation of esophagus] Vrach. gaz, 1927, 31: 1210.—Carinri, N. Su di un corpo libero del pericardio. Atti Accad. fisioci. Siena, 1935, 11. ser, 3: 711-4.—Davison, T. C. Removal of bullet from the pericardium under local anesthetic; report of a case. Arch. Surg, 1929, 18: 475-80.— Hansen & Griiningcr. Abgebrochene Nadel im Herzbeutel eines 1 '.. jahr. b hides. Munch, med. Wschr, 1936, 83: 1513.— Hentz. R. P. Pullet in the pericardial sac. U. S. Veterans Bui. M . Bull, 1929, 5: 992, 2 pl—Prospero. Z. Rcperto di un nematode nei sacco pericardico di uno storno. Clin, vet, Milano, 1908, 31: sez. prat, 177-9.—Rodriguez & Rodriguez, A. Herida del pericardio con alojamiento de cuerpo extra no (trozo de cristal) hemoterax y hemopericiirdias; extracci6n;\y sutura del pericardio, practicadas por el Dr D. Jose Ortiz de la Torre. Siglo med, 1907, 54: 338- Wright, A. D. Foreign body in pericardial cavity. Ti. M. Soc. London, 1934, 57: 35. ---- Friction sound. See under Heart sound. ---- Hemopericardium. See also subheadings Injury; Pericarditis, hemorrhagic; also names of primary diseases as Rib, Fracture, &<:. Bencini, B. Angiomi e pseudo-angiomi pericardici come rara causa di cinopi ricardio. Cuore & circol, 1936, 20: 645-54.— Benedict, E. B, & Jones, C. M. Hematopericardium; case report. N. England J. M, 1933, 208: 891.—Chamba. Un cas d'hcmopci iearde avec presence d'une aiguille dans le thorax d'un enfant. Bull Soc. radiol. med. France, 1927, 15: 109-11.—Comroe, B. I. Hemopericardium; report of a case of unknown etiology with recovery following 2 pericardial paracenteses; a review of the etiology of hemopericardium. Am. Heart J, 1934, 9: 680-5.—Delfourd. Plaie du pericarde par coup de couteau; hemopericarde; poricardotomie; guerison. Rev. med. est, 1911, 43: 431.—Dolley, K. S. Hemothorax and hemopericardium. California West. M, 1932, 37: 171.— Dumont, H, —Yater, W. M., & Itessoff, S. The diagnosis of pericardial effusions. Virginia M. Month, 1931, 58: 299-305.—West, S. Pericardial effusion Med. Press & Circ, Lond, 1908, n. ser, 86: 692-5.—Wolff- hiigel. Zur Differentialdiagnose zwischen Herzbeutelerguss und Herzvergrosserung. Verh. Kongr. inn. Med, Wien, 1907, 24: 464-70. HEART SAC 375 HEART SAC ---- Injury. See also subheadings Foreign body; Peri- carditis, traumatic; Rupture. Angle L W. Bullet wound of the pericardium; report of an unusual case. Virginia M. Month, 1932, 59: 675-7 — Dumitrescu, Du, & Noica. S. [Injuries of the pericardium without lesions of the heart] Romania med, 1935, 13: 3.— Faust, H. Nachgewiesene schwere Schadigung des Perikards nach Rontgentiefenbestrahlung der Prakordialgegend. Strah- lentherapie, 1932, 43: 749-56.—Franke, F. Zur Behandlung der Herzverletzungen (Punktion des Herzbeutels) Deut. med. Wschr 1907,33:1524-8.—Gruber, B. [Injury of pericardium] Orv. hetil, 1937. 81: mell, 139. Also Zbl. Chir, 1937, 64: 2731-3-—Guarini, C. Contributo alio studio sull'ostacolo che pud offrire il pericardio al cammino dei proiettili d'arma da fuoco (constatazione radiologica) Policlinico, 1918, 25: sez. prat 1110-2.—Gurevich, N. I. [Wound of the pericardium] Russ. vrach, 1908, 7: 1221-3.—Irger, J. M. Leber Verwun- dungen des Herzbeutels ohne Beschiidigung des Herzens. Arch. klin Chir, 1930, 163: 173-7.—Jenckel. Schuss in den Herz- beutel Med. Klin, Berl, 1915, 11: 68.—Kaminer, S, & Zondek, H. Herzbeutelveriinderungen nach Lungenschussen. Deut. med. Wschr, 1916, 42: 668.—Mastrosimone, C. Ferita da punta e taglio del pericardio. Arch. Soc. ital. chir, 1936, 42: 698-704.—Menard. A propos d'une ponction du pericarde. Arch. med. Angers, 1937, 41: 217-20.—Mereiness, L. M. [Cases of isolated wounds of the pericardium] Vest, khir, 1929, 17: 47-68.—Shipov, A. K. [Case report of injury of the pericardium] Khirurgia, Moskva, 1937, No. 9, 155.—Spitz - miiller, W. Ein seltener Fall von Herzbeutelverleizung. Arch. klin. Chir, 1928, 150: 551-62.—Stinger, E. Herida de pericardio por proyectil de arma de fuego. Rev. med. cir. Habana, 1929, 34: 917-21—Valyi, S. [Stab wound of peri- cardium] Orv. hetil, 1938, 82: 957.—Zambilovici. Plaie profonde du pericarde par une arme a feu; operation, guerison, Bull. Soc. chir. Bucarest, 1906-7, 9: 205-9. ---- Intrapericardial pressure. See also Heart, Compression; Heart sac, Dis- ease. Eichler, W. Der Druck im Herzbeutel und die Kreislauf- tttigkeit. Biol, gen, Wien, 1929, 5: 563-78.—Hauffe, G. Der Herzbeutel als Sitz einer angeblichen Dauersaugkraft. Anat. Anz, 1929-30, 68: 38-46.—Kendrew, A. A new view of the intrathoracic and intrapericardial pressures in man. Proc. R. Soc. M, Lond, 1934, 27: 1489-92.—Reissinger, H. Kreislaufstorungen bei verandertem Intraperikardialdruck. Deut. Zschr. Chir, 1927, 203:-204: 48-55.—Stephens, G. A. Portable manometer for intrapericardial pressure. Brit. M. J, 1921, 1:465. ---- Nerve supply. Francillon, M. R. Ueber die Beziehungen des Phrenicus zu Pericard und Pleura pericardiaca. Anat. Anz, 1926, 61: 235- 43.—Leriche, R, Fontaine, R, & Kunlin, J. Recherches experimentales sur le role normal et pathologique de la sensi- bilite du pericarde, de l'epicarde et de l'endocarde. Rev. chir. Par, 1932, 70: 758-65, 7 pl—Martinov, V. F. [Sensitive nerve endings in the pericardium of mammals] Russ. vrach, 1911, 10: 1976-9. Also Arch. mikr. Anat, 1914, 84: 1. Abt, 430-7, 2 pi —Morin, F, & Bonivento, E. Ricerche SuU'innervazione del pericardio. Arch. ital. anat, 1940, 43- 56-74. ---- Pericarditis. See also in 3. ser. Pericarditis. Holmes, O. W. A dissertation on acute peri- carditis. 39p. 8° Bost., 1937. Sousa Freitas, A. M. de. *Algumas palavras sobre a pericardite aguda. 45p. 8? Lisb., 1878. Achard. Pericardite. Rev. gen. clin. ther, 1933, 47: 345- 9.—Basu, I. Pericarditis. Calcutta M. J, 1935-36, 30: 385- 420 8 pl—Blumer, G. Remarks on pericarditis. Proc. Connecticut M. Soc, 1914, 122: 175-8.—Bussey, D. G. Peri- carditis. Med. Times, N. Y, 1926, 54: 291.—Elwyn, H. Acute pericarditis. Med. J. & Rec, 1926, 124: 6; 67—Fischer, M. McC. Pericarditis. Minnesota M, 1926, 9: 453-o—Hood, H. C. Pericarditis. Atlantic M. J, 1927-28, 31: 9o2.— Freedman, E. Inflammatory diseases of the pericardium. Am. J. Roentg, 1939, 42: 38-46.—Gil more C. M. Acute pericarditis: report of 14 cases. South. M. & b, 193 "*/: 129-32 ----— Pericarditis. Ibid, 1940, 102: 250.— Hannema, L. S. [Case of pericarditis] Ned. tschr. geneesk 1929, 73: 622, pl—Herrmann, G. Acute pericarditis. Mod. Concepts Card. Dis, 1933, 2: 1— Huertas y Barreo. D. 1. Casuistica de pericarditis. Arch. card, hemat, Madr, 19-0, 1: 454-63. Also Siglo med, 1921, 68: 265.-—- La peri- carditis. Ibid, 1932, 90: 645-9.—Hughes WE. Pericarditis. Med. CUn. N. America, 1927, 10: 1469-78—Izzo, R. A, Ferradas, J. B, & Laplace, J. M. Pericarditis. An. Centro tisiol, B. Air, 1936, 257-66.—Jones, B. H. Pericarditis. Med. Press & Circ, Lond, 1937, 195: 412-5.—Koch C. F. A. Pericarditis. Ned. tschr. geneesk, 1926, 70: 1349-01.— Levine, S. A. Medical aspects of pericarditis. N. England J. M 1933 208- 773—Lian. Pericarditis agudas y subaguclas. Dfa med!, B. Air, 1930-31, 3: 636-9.—Myers, R. E. Peri- carditis. J. Missouri M. Ass, 1940, 37: 200.—Ostrum, H. W. Inflammatory diseases of the pericardium. Pennsylvania M. J, 1940-41, 44: 1000-2.—Peppard, T. A. Pericarditis. Minne- sota M, 1930, 13: 529-39.—Pericarditis. J. Am. M. Ass, 1911, 56: 269-71.—Polak Daniels, L. [Pericarditis] Ned. tschr. geneesk, 1934, 78: 5614-21.—Porter, W. B. Acute pericarditis. In Cyclop. Med. (Piersol-Bortz) Phila, 1939, 3: 700-9. Also In Diagn. Treat. Cardiovasc. Dis. (Stroud, W. D.) Phila, 1940, 1: 288-304.—Shipley, A. M. Pericarditis. J. Am. M. Ass, 1937, 109: 1017-21.—Thomas, R. L. Pericarditis. Eclect. M. J, 1899, 59: 65-70.—West, S. Some points in connection with pericarditis. S. Barth. Hosp. J, Lond, 1906-7, 14: 147. ---- Pericarditis, adhesive [including Pick's syndrome] See also Polyserositis. Piquet, G. *De la symphyse du pericarde; conceptions actuelles cliniques, pathogeniques et therapeutiques. 304p. 25cm. Lyon, 1939. Allende, T. Consideraciones sobre sinfisis cardfaca. Rev. Soc. med. argent, 1896-97, 5: 210-6.—Armstrong, T. G. Adherent pericardium; constrictive and non-constrictive. Lancet, Lond, 1940, 2: 475-7.—Broadbent, W. H, & Broad- bent, J. F. H. Diseases of the pericardium; adherent peri- cardium. In Cardiac Classics (Willius, F. A.) S. Louis, 1941, 712-5.—Burwell, C. S, & Ayer, G. D. Constrictive pleuritis and pericarditis. Am. Heart J, 1941, 22: 267-75.—Bushuev, V. F. Symphysis cordis. Voen. med. J, Moskva, 1907, 220: med. spec, pt 46-9.—Castilla, C. R, & Aguirre, R. S. Peri- carditis cronica constrictiva; sindrome de Pick. Ssm. med, B. Air, 1938, 45: 1291-7.—Cavalini, E. Morbo di Pick. Ann. med. nav, Roma, 1928, 34: 326-30.—Chronic constrictive pericarditis. Brit. M. J, 1940, 1: 97.—Chronic constrictive pericarditis: Pick's disease. J. Am. M. Ass, 1935, 105: 1120.— Ciauri, R. Malattia di Friedel Pick. Gior. med. mil, 1926, 74: 501-10.—Ferreira, O, jr. Adherencia pleuro-pericardica. Brasil med, 1934, 48: 905-12.—Frosch, H. L. Pick's syndrome. N. York State J. M, 1938, 38: 1186-8.—Gerke, A. [Clinic, pathology and therapy of adhesive pericarditis] Klin, med, Moskva, 1927, 5: 871-9.—Gonzalo, G. R. Sinfisis cardfaca. Siglo med, 1924, 74: 161.—Hardwicke, C. P, & Kreisle, M. F. Chronic mediastinopericarditis. Texas J. M, 1937-38, 33: 13-5.—Herman, K. Concretio pericardii. Munch, med. Wschr, 1936, 83: 889-92.—Herzog, F. [Concretio pericardii] Orvoskepzes, 1934, 24: 147-65.—Hoist [Adhesions of the pericardium] Prakt. vrach, 1915, 14: 93; 106.—Hunter, J. B. Chronic constrictive pericarditis. Lancet, Lond, 1939, 1: 255-7.—Iniguez, Soza y Faiguenbaum. Pericarditis constrictiva; sindroma de Pick. Rev. m6d. Chile, 1941, 69: 590.—Jennings, G. H. Pick's disease. S. Mary's Hosp. Gaz, Lond, 1935, 41: 202-4.—Joselevich, M. El coraz6n aprisionado. Sem. med, B. Air, 1935, 42: 1485-505 — Kobryner, A, & Kupferstein, A. [Accretio et concretio peri- cardii] Warsz. czas. lek, 1935, 12: 869-74.—Lassen, H. C. A. [Chronic, fibrous, adhesive pericarditis] Lgeskr. laeger, 1937, 99: 567-71.—Lastra, J, Inclan Guas, R, & Reyna, E. Peri- carditis constrictiva. Arch. Soc. clin. Habana, 1941, 35: 429- 55.—Laubry, C, & Malinsky, A. La pericardite chronique constrictive. Arch. mal. coeur, 1937, 30: 841-60.—Mole, C. Considerazioni su di una sindrome di Pick. Rinasc. med, 1937, 14: 339.—Murphey, E. E. Adhesive mediastino-pericarditis, J. M. Ass. Georgia, 1926, 14: 81-6.—Parker, G. W. Chronic adhesive pericarditis. Mod. Concepts Card. Dis, 1938, 7: No. 4, 1.—Phelps, K. Chronic constrictive pericarditis. Med. Rec, Houston, 1941, 35: 787-9.—Ramond, L. Symphyse eardiaque. Presse med, 1935, 43: 1905.—Rosier, O. A. Ueber die Ilerzbeutelverwachsungen. Wien. kUn. Wschr, 1928, 41: 153-6 —Shipley, A. M. Adhesive pericarditis. In Cyclop. Med. (Piersol-Bortz) Phila, 1939, 3: 974-6—Shutt, C. H. Shaggy heart, or pericarditis with adhesions. Med. Fort- nightly, 1907, 32: 491-3.—Smith, H. L, & Willius, F. A. Pericarditis; chronic adherent pericarditis. Arch. Int. M„ 1932 50: 171-5.—Stewart-Wallace, A. M. Pick's syndrome. Proc! R. Soc. M, Lond, 1935-36, 29: 125.—Szekeres, O. A szivburok lemezeinek teljes osszenovese. Gy6gyaszat, 1910, 50: 842-5.—T. La pericardite adesiva cronica. Gazz. osp, 1909 30: 131—Vaizey, J. M. Pick's syndrome (pericardial) Proc! R. Soc. M, Lond, 1936-37, 30: 1073.—Valach, L. [Adhesive mediastino-pericarditis] Bratisl. lek. hsty, 192o, 5: 153-60 pl.—White, P. D. Constrictive pericarditis. South. M & S 1930, 92: 406. ----— Chronic pericarditis. Mod. Concepts Card. Dis, 1933, 2: 1. ------ Chronic constrictive pericarditis. Guy's Hosp. Rep, Lond, 1935, 85: 258. Also In Cyclop Med. (Piersol-Bortz) Phila, 1939, 3: 709-15. ______Chronic constrictive pericarditis; also called Pick s disease, concretio cordis, and chronic compression of the heart. In Diagn. Treat. Cardiovasc. Dis. (Stroud, Vv. D.) Phila, 1940, I • 305-28 —Wilks, S. Adherent pericardium as a cause of cardiac disease, 1871. Guy's Hosp. Rep, Lond, 1935, 85: 264-73. ____ Pericarditis, adhesive: Calcification. See also subheading Calcification. Bonniger, M. A. *Ueber das Panzerherz [Berlin] 25p. 21cm. Lengerich, 1937. HEART SAC 376 HEART SAC Despotoff, B. *La pericardite calcifiante. 66p. 8? Par., 1934. Kahler, W. *Zur Frage des Panzerherzens. 22p. 8? Berl., 1933. Lydtin*. H. [O.] *Ein Fall von Pericarditis calculosa (Steinherz) 25p. 8? Miinch., 1907. Roll, H. *Panzerherzen unter Beriicksichti- gung eines Falles und seine chirurgische Behand- lung [Bonn] 19p. 8? Bottrop, 1932. Vass, A. *Ueber das Panzerherz [Leipzig] 18p. 8? [Asz6d, Hungary] 1927. Weismuller, P. P. N. *Ueber Obliteratio pericardii mit Kalkeinlagerungen (Auszug) lip. 8? Bonn, 1923. Arnesen, J. [Case of calcified pericarditis (Panzerherz)] Norsk, mag. laigevid, 1927, 88: 688-91.—Arrillaga, F. C, & Mordeglia, M. Pericarditis cronica constrictiva con fibrosis pericardica y calcificaci6n parcial, travendo el sindrome de Pick, 1896. In Libro de oro M. R. Castex, B. Air, 1940. 1: 72-81.—Barbacci, G. Contributo alio studio della pi'rii■anlite calcifica. Radiol, med, MUano, 1935, 22: 152 7.—Barnes, A. R, & Harrington, S. W. Calcified constricting pericardium. Proc. Mayo Clin, 1938, 13: 673-8.—Battro, A, Quirno, N, & Gonzalez Segura, R. Chasquido protodiastolico en un caso de calcificacicn pericardica. Rev. argent, card, 1939-40, 6: 173-8.—Belot & De Vulpian, P. Pericardite calcifiante. Bull. Soc. radiol. med. France, 1933, 21: 745.—Berner, F. Die kymographische Untersuchung der Pericarditis calculosa. Arch. klin. Chir, 1938-39, 194: 458-76 — Bischcff, L. Panzer- herz mit Einflusstauung; kasuistischer Beitrag mit 3 Rontgen- bildern. Schweiz. med. Wschr, 1941, 71: 1074.—Borchardt, M. Die Pericarditis chronica adhaesiva und das Panzerherz, Pericarditis chronica calculosa sive calcificata. J. internat. chir, Brux, 1939, 4: 49-102.—Breu. W. Funktionelle Mitral- stenose bei einem I'all von Panzerherz. V ien. med. Wschr, 1940, 90: 697—Castex, M. R, Mazzei, E. S, & Caputo, G. Sindrome de Friedel Pick por pericarditis constrictiva cr6nica con calcificaci6n pericardica. Prensa med. argent, 1939, 26: pt 2, 1619-24. Also Rev. As. med. argent, 1939, r>3: 959-62 — Dax, R. Bericht uber zwei opcrierte FaUe von Pericarditis calculosa. Zbl. Chir, 1935, 62: 2334-8.—De Giovanni. G. Della sinfisi pericardica calcificante con nuclei di ossifieazione. Ann. med. nav, Roma, 1933, 39: 261-79, 6 pl—Dessy. G. Sopra un caso di pericardite adesiva con calcihcazione. Dia- gnosi, 1933, 12:306-19.—Duvoir, M, Pichon, E, & de Vulpian, P. Ln cas de pericardite calcifiante (pericaide de cuirasse) Bull. Soc. med. hop. Paris, 1933, 3. ser, 49: 1520-30.—Duvoir, M, Pollet, L, & Chapireau, P. Ln nouveau cas de pericardite calcifiante. Ibid, 1934, 3. ser, 50: 258-64.—Duvoir, M, Pollet, L. [et al] Etude radiographique, anatomique et chimique d'un cas de pericardite calcifiante. Ibid, 871-81.— Eliason, E. L, & Brown, R. B. Calcified constrictive peri- carditis. Ann. Surg, 1940, 111: 446-52. Also Pub. Dep. Surg. Lniv. Pennsylvania, 1939-40, No. 4, 446-52.—Filip, L. [Calcified pericarditis with callous pleuiomediastinitis] Cas. lek. Cesk, 1932, 71: 197.—Friedliinder, ('. Leber Panzerherz. Fortsch. Rontgenstrahl, 1926. 34: 14 5-52.— Gonzalez Sa- bathie, L. El ruido protodiastolic! de la calcificacion del pericardio. Rev. argent, card, 1938, 5: 396-403. Also In his Temas cardiol, B.. Air, 1939, 2: 207-45.—Gravano, L, & Aztiria, A. H. Calcificaci6n pericardica; sindrome de Pick. Sem. med, B. Air, 1938, 45: 1225-30. Also Rev. As. m6d. argent, 1938, 52: 88-93—Gravier, Bret & Piquet. Peri- cardite calcaire; bruit protodiastolique simulant un dedouble- ment mitral. Lyon med, 1938, 161: 421-3.—Hessmann, A, & IsraeUki, M. Panzerherz. Rontgenpraxis, 1932, 4: 112-8.— Horsch, K. Zur Frage der Pericarditis calculosa. Mitt. Grenzgeb. Med. Chir, 1932-33, 43: 370-4.—Joselevich, M. Dilatacion acentuada de la auricula derecha en la calcificacion pericardica; el sindrome de la gran dilataci5n dextro-auricular. Dfa med, B. Air, Ed. espec, 1940, 147-9.—Kossinskaia, N. S. [Roentgendiagnosis of armored heart] Vest, rentg, 1937 18- 248-54.—Leaman, W. G, & Yastine, J. H, 2d. Calcification of the pericardium; report of a case in a boy aged 12. Am. J. Roentg, 1940, 43: 35-41.—Lemieux, R., Leblond, S, & Nadeau, H. A propos d'une pericardite calcifiante. Laval med, 1937, 2: 49-60—Lenker, J. L. Pericarditis calculosa Pennsylvania M. J, 1930-31, 34: 89—Massino, S. V., & Weisfeld, h. G. [Case of armored heart] Probl. tuberk Moskva, 1938, No. 3, 122—Menetrier, P, & Pascano, a! Symphyse du pericarde avec calcification massive au pourtour ties 2 ventrieules. Bull. Soc. med. hop. Paris, 1915, 3. ser, 39: 722-8.—Moschinski, G. Die Pericarditis calculosa und ihre Symptome. Deut. med. Wschr, 1941, 67: 256-60.—Pallasse. Pericardite calcifiante avec signes de rettecissement mitral Bull Soc. med. hop. Lyon, 1908, 7: 401-3.—Popescu, I. M, & Gligore, V. [CUnical and radiological investigations on calci- fication of the pericardium with special reference to a case of i.-.eipient calcification of the pericardium] Cluj. med. 1938 19: 111 -4—Pozharitki, I. F. [Calcified pericardium] 'Khar- kov. M J, 1914, 17: 52.V-16, pl—Rusconi, M. Ln caso di pericarditis calculosa. Cuore & circol, 1927, 11: 485-93__ Samson. M, & Hurrd, J. A. Pericardite calcifiante. Laval md. I'.i36. 1: 149-53.—Schaaff, F. A. Coeur en cuirasse examen la.tiologique in vivo et n6cropsique. Bull. Soc. radiol m6d. France, 1936, 24: 153.—Schwartz, G, & Staebler, A. Ln cas de pericardite calcifiee. Arch, mal coeur, 1936, 29: 237-41.—Singer-Schulcr. W. Beitrag zur Kenntnis des Panzerherzens mit ekltrokardiographischen Veranderungen Schweiz. med. Wschr, 1941, 71: 270-2.- Smith, H. L, & Willius, F. A. Pericarditis; calcification of pericardium Arch. Int. M, 1932, 50: 184.—Stehr. L. Rontgenbeobachtung, Pathologie und Klinik des Panzerherzens. Zschr. klin. Med, 1937-38, 133: 371-94.—Stone, W. J. Adherent pericardium with calcification. Am. Heart. J, 1925-26, I : 434-41.— Virkkunen, M. [Case report of pericarditis calculosa lenta] Duodecim, Helsinki, 1938, 54: 610-8.—Wald, B. [Pericarditis calcificans] G\ ogyiiszat, 1934, 74: 404.—Westermann, H. H. Die Venendruckbestimmung beim Panzerherzen durch Infnirot- aufnahmen. Chirurg, 1939, 11: 480-5.—Willius, F. A. CUnic on chronic adherent pericarditis with calcification of the pericardium. Proc. Mayo Clin, 1936, 11: 312-7.—Yater. W. M. Calcification of the pericardium and chronic cardiac compression; report and discussion of 4 cases. J. Mount Sinai Hosp. N. York, 1941-42, 8: 1144-60.—Zagari, G. Calcifica- zione del pericardio; corazza calcare del cuore. Rass. internaz. clin. ter, 1934, 15: 3-14. ---- Pericarditis, adhesive: Casuistics. Azema & Serr. Note sur un cas de symphyse cardiaque generalisee. Toulouse med, 1904, 2. ser, 6: 173.—Blalock, A, & Burwell, C. S. Chronic pericardial disease; report of 28 cases of constrictive pericarditis. Surg. Gyn. Obst, 1941, 73: 433-61.—Canella, C Considerazioni cUniche su due casi di mediastinopericardite adesiva parziale. Clin. med. ital, 1938, 69: 433-42.—Carrieu, M, & Janbon, M. Pericardite avec cirrhose hypertrophique hyperspienoiriegaliq le sans ascite. Bull. Soc. sc. med. biol. Montpellier, 11125-26, 7: 344-9.—Colleville. Endopericardite avec symphyse du peri- carde et anevrysme partiel du cceur. Union med. nord-est, 1907, 31: 73-8.—Constrictive pericarditis; presentation of a case. Minnesota M, 1942, 25: 42.—Cranfield, H. V., Gwyn, N. B. [et al] A case of adhesive constrictive pericarditis (Pick's disease) Canad. M. Ass. J, 1937, 36: 449-53.— East, T. Two cases of Pick's syndrome. Proc. R. Soc. M, Lond, 1936-37, 30: 763.—Holm. Ein Fall von Pericarditis adhaesiva totalis comprimens. Med. Welt, 1927, 1: 357.— Hurley, T. E. V. Two cases of chronic mediastino-pericarditis. Austral. M. J, 1911, n. ser, 1: 17.—Kirschner, M., & Matthes, M. Leber einen diagnostisch und operativ interessanten Fall von Obliteration des Perikards. Deut. med. Wschr, 1926, 52: 221-3.—Lautier. Sur un cas de symphyse cardiaque avec degen6rescence calcaire des valves de la mitrale. J. med. Bor- deaux, 1907,37:185.—Leclerc. Sur un cas de symphyse cardiaque Lyon med, 1907,109:109.—Martini, T,Cordes,G.M,& Josele- vich, M. Las pericarditis cr6nicas adhesivas (estudio com- parative de cuatro observaciones clinicas) Sem. med, B. Air, 1927, 34: pt 2, 805-18.—Matthes & Kirschner. Ein diagno- stisch und operativ bemerkenswerter Fall von Concretio peri- cardii. Klin. Wschr, 1926, 5: 579.—Oberhofer-Sik, D. [Case of concretio et accretio cordis] LijeC. vjes, 1940, 62: 616.—Redtenbacher [Fall von Concretio pericardU cum corde] Mitt. Ges. inn. Med. Kinderh. Wien, 1909, 8: 189.—Robinson, W. Chronic indurative mediastino-pericarditis. Northumber- land Durham M. J, 1895, 3: 204.—Rodov, I. S. [Two cases of obliteratio pericardii simplex] Klin, med, Moskva, 1927, 5: 381-4.—Rothstein, J. L. Pick's disease in a 12-year old boy. Am. J. Dis. Child, 1934, 48: 1446.—Sarma, A. V. S, & Mahadevan, M. A case of Pick's disease. J. Ind. M. Ass, 1940-41, 10: 122.—Shaw, C. A case of Pick's syndrome. Lancet, Lond, 1941, 1: 76.—Siddons, A. H. M. A case of Pick's disease. Ibid, 1936, 2: 1038.—Soliterman, M. L., & Ratner, G. G. [Case of mediastinal, adhesive pleuroperi- carditis in an otherwise healthy subject] Klin, med, Moskva, 1930, 8: 153-5.—Svoiekhotov, A. S. [Callous mediastino- pericarditis] Vrach. gaz, 1909, 16: 301.—Synhorst, J. B. Pick's disease, case report. J. Iowa M. Soc, 1926, 16: 19.— Takssar, D. [Rare case of mediastino-pericarditis (obUteratio pericardii)] Vrach. gaz, 1928, 32: 1717-9.—Tremaine, M. J. (subacute Pick's disease (polyserositis) with polyarthritis and glomerulonephritis; report of 2 fatal cases. N. England J. M, 1934,211:754-9. ---- Pericarditis, adhesive: Diagnosis. Muller, M. *Ueber die Diagnose der Con- cretio perikardii. 43p. 8? Konigsb., 1913. Callerio, G. Contributo alia diagnostiea e alia patogenesi del morbo di Pick. Minerva med. Tor, 1930, 21: 301-7.— Cushing, E. H, & Feil, H. S. Chronic const i ietive pericarditis, electrocardiographic and clinical studies. Am. J. M. Sc, 1936, 192: 327-34, 4 pl—France, R. The use of the electro- cardiogram in the diagnosis of adhesive pericardiomediastinitis. Bull. Johns Hopkins Hosp, 1938, 63: 104-10.—Grossmann, M. Verschiedenheit der Salyrgandiurese als Zeichen partieller Einflusstauung bei Herzbeutelverwachsung. Wien. klin. V\schr, 1928, 41: 056. ------ Zur Differentialdiagnose der Herzbeutelverwachsung. Schweiz. med. Wschr, 1931, 61: 372-6.—Hochrein, M. Eine neue Methode zur Erkennung der Pericarditis adhaesiva. Munch, med. Wschr, 1930, 77: 588-91. ------ Der kUnische Nachweis der Perikardver- wachsungen. In Libro de oro M. R. Castex, B. Air, 1938, 2: 642-50. ------ Fruhdiagnose und Therapie der Pericarditis HEART SAC 377 HEART SAC adhaesiva. Zbl. Chir, 1939, 66: 1063-7. ------& Laplace, L. Der oneumotachographische Nachweis der Pericarditis ad- haesiva. Deut. Arch. klin. Med, 1933-34, 176: 113-27.— Importance (The) of recognizing chronic constrictive peri- carditis (Picks disease) N. England J. M, 1935, 213: 831 — Latkowski, J. [Changes in the electrocardiogram in adhesions of the pericardium to its surroundings] Polska gaz. lek, 1932, 11: 721-4, 16 pl—McGuire, J, & Hauenstein, V. Diagnosis and treatment of concretio cordis: accretio cordis. Ohio M. J, 1937, 33: 268-71.—Pavel, S. [Diagnosis of peri cardial adhesions] Cas. lek. Cesk, 1933, 72: 1788-93, 4 pl.— Sampson, J. J, & Rosenblum, H. Adhesive mediastino- pericarditis with normal cardiac electrical axis rotation on postural change. Am. Heart J, 1934, 10: 240-7. Also repr.— Schneiderbaur, A. Zur Diagnose der chronischen Mediastino- perikarditis. Munch, med. Wschr, 1937, 84: 1891-3.— Sprague, H. B. The differential diagnosis of congestive heart failure and constrictive pericarditis (Pick's disease) Am. Heart J, 1936, 12:443-7. ---- Pericarditis, adhesive, juvenile. Flesch, A., & Schossberger, S. [Diagnosis and nature of pericardial adhesions in children] Budapesti Orvosegy. evk, 1906, 53-5.—Giraud, P, & Zuccarelli, J. Ectasie aortique et symphvse pericardique chez un enfant de 10 ans. Marseille med, 1923, 60: 1386-9.—Holt, E. Chronic adhesive pericarditis in childhood. Am. J. M. Sc, 1929. 178: 615-31.— Jacoby. N. M. Pick's disease. Brit. J. Child. Dis, 1941, 38: 32.—Lengsfeld, W. Leber die Lmklammerung des Herzens mit Volhardscher Einfluszstauung im Kindesalter. Jahrb. Kinderh, 1928-29, 3. F, 72: 95-110.—Nobecourt, P. Les symphyses rhumatismales du pericarde chez les enfants. Rev. gen. chn. ther, 1932, 46: 417-24.—Rothstein, J. L. Chronic adhesive pericarditis in children and its surgical treatment; historical aspect; etiology; pathology; symptom complex; diagnostic signs; differential diagnosis; prognosis; treatment. Arch. Pediat, N. Y, 1934, 51: 219-39. ------ Report of case of Pick's disease in a 12 year old child; abstracts from the literature of cases operated on, with an analysis of results; conclusions. Ibid, 28S-309, ch.—Stolte, K. Zur Therapie der Herzbeutelverwachsungen im Kindesalter. Beitr. klin. Chir, 1926, 136: 368-74.—Symon, J. Consideraciones sobre peri- carditis constrictivas y adhesivas ctenicas en el nifio. Rev. chilena pediat, 1941, 12: 63-77.—Vaizey, J. M. Pick's syndrome. Brit. J. Child. Dis, 1941, 38: 66.—Zambrano, E. La pericardite cronica adesivo nei bambini. Pediatria (Riv.) 1934.42: 1113-22. ---- Pericarditis, adhesive: Manifestation. See also Ascites. Aquino, T. Sinfisi pericardica con sintomatologia da cole- cistite. Policlinico, 1935, 42: sez. prat, 662-6.—Ascoli, M. Note di semeiologia; arretramento sistolico del torace antero- laterale destro con avanscatto diastolico, sintoma di accretio cordis. Riforma med, 1931, 47: 1619.—Burwell, C. S. A clinical study of adhesive pericarditis. South. M. J, 1931, 24: 949-52. Also Proc. Interst. Postgrad. M. Ass. N. America, 1932, 7: 110-3, pl—Castex, M. R, Capdehourat, E. L., & Mazzei, E. S. Fisiopatogenia de la cianosis en el sindrome de Pick; pericarditis constrictiva cr6nica. Prensa med. argent, 1939, 26: pt 2, 2263-5.—Caussel & Vinon. Sur 2 cas de symphyse cardiaque latente. Montpellier med, 1914, 38: 32-7.—Cunha Motta, L, & Lemie da Fonseca, J. Estudo clinico e anatomo-pathologico de um caso de syndrome de Hutinel Ann. Fac. med. S. Paulo, 1931, 6: 51-71, 4 pl— Dagnini, G. Spostamento paradosso della retrazione sistolica della punta in un caso di aderenza intra ed extra pericardica. Riv. crit. clin. med. Fir, 1901, 2: 379-87.—Dressier, W. Pulsations of the wall of the chest; pulsations associated with adhesive pericardial disease. Arch. Int. M, 1937, 60: 654— 62.—Josue, O, & Paillard, H. Symphyse cardiaque, syndrome surteno-vasculaire, anevrisme du coeur. Bull Soc. med. hop. Paris, 1909, 3. ser, 26: 148-61.—Kalif-Kalif, M. J. [Symptoms and diagnosis of adhesive pericarditis] Vrach. delo, 1938, 20: 93-100.—Martini, T, & Joselevich, M. Sinfisis intraperi- cardica exclusiva; asistolia miocardica. Sem. med, B. Air, 1929, 36: 1368-74.—Massimo Michelazzi, A. Ipertrofia della mammella maschile nei morbo di Pick. Rass. ter. pat. clin, 1932, 4: 577-86.—Montes Pareja, J. Algunas consideraciones clinicas con respecto a una observacion de pericarditis callosa. Rev. med. lat. amer, B. Air, 1930-31, 16: 519-36.—Nannini, G. Sul cosidetto morbo di Pick dal punto di vista clinico. Minerva med. Tor, 1928, 8: 388-419.—Ortner, N. Leber Concretio et accretio cordis, Mediastinitis fibrosa partialis und die Entstehung echter systolischer Herzeinziehungen. Med. Klin, Berl, 1907, 3: 1089-93. ------ Ein falsches Broad- bemsches Zeichen. Berl klin. Wschr, 1915, 52: 758. ---:--- Zur Klinik der sogenannten Mediastino-Pericarditis adhaesiva. Med. Klin, Berl, 1933, 29: 11-3.—Peters, J. T. [Explanation of Hope sign in pericardial adhesion] Geneesk. gids, 1931, 9: 925-32.—Stradiotti, G. Contributo alia semejotica della sinfisi pericardica. Gazz. osp, 1932, 53: 99-103.— Tornai, J. Adatok a pericarditis adhaesiva tiinettanahoz. Orv. hetil, 1912, 56: 1063-7.—Wenckebach, K. F. Beobachtungen bei exsudativer und adhiisiver Perikarditis. Zschr. klin. Med, 1910, 71: 402-20, pl. ---- Pericarditis, adhesive: Pathogenesis. Dtjmaine, R. ^Contribution a l'etude de la symphyse cardiaque d'origine tuberculeuse. 74p 8? Lyon, 1901. Beck, C. S. Chronic cardiac compression produced by con- tracture of extrinsic scars on the heart (Pick's disease, constric- tive pericarditis) Mod. Concepts Card. Dis, 1939, 8: No 10 1.—Castellanos, A, Sanchez Santiago, B., & Montero, R. Pohserositis tuberculosa evolueionando hacia una pericarditis constrictiva cronica. Arch. med. inf., Habana, 1939, 8: 177- 92.—Castex, M. R, Capdehourat, E. L, & Mazzei, E. S. Fisiopatogenia de la cianosis en el sindrome de Pick. Bol. Acad nac. med. B. Aires, 1939, 563-9.—Facatselli, N. M. Peri- cardite et symphyse cardiaque tuberculeuses. Arch. med. enf, 1937, 40: 453-7.—Ferrari, R. Su la patogenesi della nbrechia del cuore; osservazioni anatomo-patologiche e speri- mentali sul morbo di Pick. Bull Soc. med. chir, Pavia, 1929, n. ser, 4: 349-88.—Fogarasi, I. Megjegyzesek a Pick-feie ugynevezett pseudo-cirrhosis pericardiaca pathogenesisehez. Orv. hetil, 1911, 55: 621-5.—Fournial & Marquez. Symphyse cardiaque totale. d'origine tuberculeuse. J. med. Bordeaux, 1907, 37: 216.—Glenn, E. E. Traumatic constrictive peri- carditis. J. Missouri M. Ass, 1940, 37: 7-11.—Gordon, W. H, & Gose, A. C. A case of constrictive pericarditis due to actino- mycosis. Hosp. News, Wash, 1940, 7: No. 19, 15-22, 7 fig.— Goyena, J. R. Mediastinopericarditis tuberculosa. Sem. med, B. Air, 1928, 35: pt 2, 832-44.—Gravano, L, & Aztiria, A. H. Mediastino-pericarditis cronica constrictiva, con sindrome de Pick, como etapa final de una poliserositis tuberculosa ctenica adhesiva; observaci6n anatomo-clinica. Rev. As. med. argent, 1939, 53: 387-93.— Hambursin. Observation de pericardite consecutive a une perihepatite. Presse med. beige, 1869-70, 22: 389.—Hosier, R. M, & Williams, J. E. An experimental study of cardiopericardial adhesions. Proc. Soc. Exp. Biol, N. Y, 1936, 34: 528-30. Also J. Thorac. Surg, 1936, 5: 629- 40.—Koletsky, S, & Brownlee, R. E. Fatal constrictive peri- carditis due to isolated suppurative pericarditis the result of infected abortion; case report. Ann. Int. M, 1940-41, 14: 924-9.—Lacka, A, & Chodkowska, A. [Case of tuberculous, adhesive pericarditis] Pedjat. polska, 1936, 16: 376-82.— Luisada, A, & Torraca, L. Le mediastino-pericarditi croniche. Studium, Nap, 1936, 26: 28-35.—Manca. S. Tentativi di riproduzione sperimentale della mediastino-pericardite cronica. Riv. pat. clin. tuberc. 1934, 8: 773-8, pl—Mitchell, G. F. Tuberculous pericarditis and Pick's disease. Am. J. Dis. Child, 1938, 55: 1119. ------ Tuberculous pericarditis and Pick's disease; report of 3 cases. Arch. Pediat, 1938, 55: 157- 65.—Poncet. Symphyse pericardique et endocardite ancienne d'origine tuberculeuse. Lyon med, 1907, 109: 1125.—Schlo- movitz, B. H. Adhesive pericarditis as protection in multiple cardiac infarction. Med. Bull. Veterans Admin, 1936, 13: 135-9.—Schwerdtfeger, H. Leber die Aetiologie der Peri- karditis, besonders der Pericarditis adhaesiva. Mitt. Grenzgeb. Med. Chir, 1932-33, 43: 336-51.—Storti, E. Studio sulla patogenesi dell'ascite nella sindrome di pericardite adesiva cronica tipo Pick. Arch, pat, Bologna, 1937-38, 17: 346-90 — Thompson, S. A. Development of cardio-pericardial adhesions following the use of talc. Proc. Soc. Exp. Biol, N. Y„ 1939, 40: 260.—Yodice, A. Pericarditis compresiva experimental; comunicacion previa. Acci6n med, B. Air, 1940, 10: 145-7. ---- Pericarditis, adhesive: Pathology. See also Liver, Pseudocirrhosis; Polyserositis. Wiemann, W. *Ueber die pericarditische Pseudolebercirrhose (F. Pick) 31p. 8? Miinch., 1905. Baduel, A. Etiologia e patogenesi di certe forme di pseudo- cirrosi del fegato e contributo alia conoscenza del morbo di Pick. Lav. Congr. med. int., 1908, i»: 192-5.—Bonafos. Observat ons et reflexions pathologiques sur les concretions polypiformes du cceur. J. med. Toulouse, 1862, 4. ser, 1: 129-38.—Burchell, H. B. Adjustments in coronary circulation after experimental coronary occlusion with particular reference to vascularization of pericardial adhesions. Arch. Int. M, 1940, 65: 240-62.—Casuso, A. Serositis cr6nica multiple, poliserositis o hialoserositis (enfermedad de Curschmann, de Concato y de Pick) Vida nueva, Havana, 1931, 26: 339-58.— Condorelli, L. Accretion sans concretion. Presse med, 1937, 45: 1831-5.—Delbet, P. La symphyse cardio-thoracique extra-pericardique. Ibid, 1915, 23: 113.—Gouley, B. A. Constriction of the pulmonary artery by adhesive pericarditis. Am. Heart J, 1937, 13: 470-82.—Jemma, R, & Mauro, C. Sopra un caso di cirrosi epatica d'origine pericardica. Pediatria, Nap, 1908, 2. ser, 6: 481-90.—Luisada, A. Le forme adesive, callose e calcificate della regione mediastino-diaframmatica. Arch. ital. chir, 1935, 41: 932-42.------ Le mediastino- pericarditi croniche (le forme adesive, callose e calcihcata della regione mediastino-diaframmatica) Policlinico, 1935, 42: sez. prat, 2479-84.—Moses, H. M. Adhesive pericarditis and cardiac hypertrophy. Long Island M. J, 1907, 1: 316.— Priesel, A. Ueber eine Modifikation der Rokitanskyschen Sektionsmethode des Herzens bei der Herzbeutelverwachsung. Wien. kUn. Wschr, 1929, 42: 439.—Ramsey, T. L. Multiple serositis, Kelly; pericarditic pseudocirrhosis of the Uver, Pick. HEART SAC 37S HEART SAC J. Lab. Clin. M, 1937-38, 23: 39-46. Roberts. J. E. H. Chronic constrictive pericarditis (Pick's syndrome): report and specimen. Proc. R. Soc. M, Lond, 1936--37, 30: 704 — Sirard. M. H. Patholoiry and symptomatology of chronic adhesive pericarditis. N. York M. J, 1907, 85: 4S8-96. AN,, repr.—Sprague, H. B, Huron, H. A, & White, P. D. Adherent pericardium and lick's syndrome; an autopsy Study. N. England J. M, 1932, 207: 4S3. ---- Pericarditis, adhesive: Physiopathology. Basabe, H. La velocidad de sedimentaci6n de los hematfes en el sindrome secuela de Pick. Sem. med, B. Air, 1935, 42: 1890-94.—Beck, C. S, & Cushing, E. H. Circulatory stasis of intrapericardial origin; the clinical and surgical aspects of the Pick syndrome. J. Am. M. Ass, 1934, 102: 1543-8.—Blalock, A, & Burwell, C. S. Thoracic duct lymph pressure in concretio cordis. J. Lab. Clin. M, 1935-36. 21: 296. ------ Chronic constrictive pericarditis; physiologic and pathologic considera- tions. J. Am. M. Ass, 1938, 110: 265-71. Also repr.— Burwell, C. S, & Strayhorn, W. I). Concretio cordis; a clinical study, with observations on the venous pressure and cardiac output. Arch. Surg, 1932, 34: 106-9.—Chevers, N. Observa- tions on the diseases of the orifice and valves of the aorta, 1842; diminution of the heart and great vessels, following obliteration of the pericardial cavity. Guy's Hosp. Rep Lond, 1935, 85: 259-63.—Ferrari, R. Leber das cxperinientelle Herzodem und uber die Stauungstypen bei der IlciMieutelverwachsung. Virchows Arch, 1930, 276: 163-9. Fisher, T. Are pericardial adhesions of meat importance? Hi it. M. .1, 1907. 1: 840.— Maltby, A. IL Cardiac output in the Pick syndrome. Proc. Soc. Exp. Biol, N. Y, 1934. 31: 853.---Moritz, A. R, Hudson, C. L, & Orgain, E. S. Augmentation of the extracardiac anastomoses of the coronary arteries through pericardial adhesions. J. Exp. M, 1932, 56: 927-31, 2 pl—Paviot, J, & Froment. Insuffisance fonctionnelle aortique et mitrale par symphyse partielle du pericarde et gros cceur. Bull. Soc. med. h6p. Lyon, 1903, 2: 1-6.— Pela. Insufficenza circolatoria nella mediastino-pericardite. Bull. sc. med, Bologna, 1936, 108: 225.—Rohde, C. Die Stauung der unteren Hohlvene vor dem rechten Herzen und ihre Bedeutung im Krankheitsbilde der Pericarditis adhaesiva. Deut. Zschr. Chir, 1927, 203:-204: 18-41.-—Yodice, A. Hipertensi6n linfdtica en el sindrome de pericarditis compresiva. Acci6n med, B. Air, 1940, 10: 193. ---- Pericarditis, adhesive: Radiography. Belbenoit, S, & Bonte, G. Les images radiologiques de inailhment pericardique. J. radiol. electr, 1939, 23: 248-62.— Uerner. F. Die 1 nlYeientialdiagnose zwischen Accretio und Concietio peiicaidii en, inii-i upta im Kvmogramm. Deut. Arch. Klii. Med, I93S. IK2: 88-100.—Freedman, E. The loentgenolo'jical diaium-i- ot cardiac compression due to peri- cardial um ladln-ive pci ie;,i.litis) Am. J. Roentg, 1937, 37: 739-55.—Johnson, S. E. The roentgenkymograph as a new aid in the diagnosis of adhesive pericarditis. Surg. Gyn. Obst, 1935, 61 : 169-74. ------ Roentgen kymography as an aid in the diagnosis of constrictive pericarditis. Kentucky M. J, 1941. 39: 70-2.—Konstam, G. L. S, & Wood, F. G. Two cases of Pick's disease .studied will the aid of kymography. Brit. M. .1, 1939. 1: 498-500--Rigler, L. G, Wangensteen, O. H, A- Friedell. H. L. Roentgen kymography in constrictive pericarditis Am. J. Roentg, 1941, 46: 765-77 [Discussion] 790.—Timparo, M. Concretio pericardi. Ann. radiol, Bologna, 1934, 8: 87-109.—Zdansky, E. Zur Rontgendiag- nostik der schwieUgen Perikarditis. Med. Klin, Berl, 1931, 27: 1567. ------ Zur Diagnose der Concretio und Accretio cordis. Fortsch. Rontgenstrahl, 1931, 44: 48-60. ------ Was leistet die Rontgenuntersuchung fiir die Diagnose der schwieUgen Perikarditis? Aerztl. Prax, Wien, 1934, 8- 226. ---- Pericarditis, adhesive: Surgery. See also Heart sac, Surgery. Aslanian, D. *Resultats eloignes du traite- ment chirurgical de la symphyse pericardique; etude clinique et radiokymographique. 79p. 25cm. Par.", 1938. Gurewitz, G. M. T. *Ueber drei diagnosti- zierte und mit Erfolg operierte Falle von Con- cretio pericardii. 36p. 8? Konigsb., 1932. Hesse, H. *Ueber Herzbeutelverwachsungen und ihre operative Behandlung. 46p. 8? Berl., 1928. Jacq, L. *Etude d'un cas de symphyse mediastino-pericardique traite chirurgicalement. 59p. 8? Par., 1911. Merigot, L. *Etude critique .sur le traite- ment chirurgical de la svmphyse pericardique. 187p. 8? Par., 1934. Torraca, L. La cura chirurgica della peri- cardite adesiva. p.457-590. 8? Roma, 1936. In Arch. Soc. ital. chir, 1936, 42: Bascourret & Weill Ln cas de symphyse cardiaque traite par la phrenicectoinie. Hull. Soc med. h6p. Paris, 1933, 3. ser, 49: 791 9. IScnnlitti-Valcntini, F. Contribute al trattamento chirui-gico del morbo di Pick. Policlinico, 1937, 11: sez. prat, 19S0-2002.- Ito-gild. D. |Fibrous mediastino- pericarditis (fibrous pericardii i.«) will special reference to operative treatment] Lgeskr. laeger, 1937, 99: 32S 39.— Bottin. J. La pericardite chronique adhesive et l,'op6iatinn de Volhard-Selmiieden. liege med, 1933, 26: 1-12—Brccliol. Role de la phrenicectoinie dans le traitement de la symphyse pericardique. Bull Soe. nat. chir. Par, 1932, 58: 429 31. Desplas, B. Traitement chirurgical dc la symphyse cardiaque J. med. fr, 1926, 15: 486- S. Dolley, F. S, & Jones, J. ('. The surgical relief of Pick's syndrome. Proc. Consr. Pan- pacific Surg. Ass, 1939, 166-8. -Foster, J. M, jr. & Prey, D. The surgical treatment of adhesive pericarditis, with report of a case. Colorado M, 1934, 31: 244-50.—Graham, E. A. De- compression of the heart. Ann. Surg, 1929, 90: 817-28.— Gravier. Crevssel A: Piquet. A propos du traitement chirurgical de la symphyse du pericardi'. Lyon med, I93S, 162: 10-2.— Guleke. Die chirunrischo Behandlung der l'ei iearditis ad- haesiva. Mitt. Orenzgob. Med. Chir, 1926-27. 40: 252-76.— Hanebuth & Naegeli, T. Zur operativen Therapie der Medi- astinopericarditis. Med. Klin, Berl, 1927, 23: 1253-7.— Harrington, S. W, & Barnes, A. R. Diagnosis and surgical treatment of chronic constrictive pericarditis. South. Surgeon, 1940, 9: 459-81.— Henschen, C. Combination von I'eri- cardresection, linksseiliger Phrenieusausschaltung, Leber- fontanellbildung und Tansiiii-Talma-Operation bei der chi- rurgischen Behandlung des Panzerherzens. Arch. ital. chir, 1938 52: 528-42- Heuer, G.J, & Stewart, H. J. The surgical treatment of chronic constrictive pericarditis. Surg. Gyn. Obst, 1939, 68: 979 1001.- Hochrein. M. Nachweis und Behandlung der Pericarditis adhaesiva. Zschr. Kreislaufforsch, 1935, 27: 761--70. —Joselevich, M. Breves comentarios sobre el tratamiento quirurgieo de la sinfisis pericardica. Dfa m6d, I'.. Air, 1929-30, 2: 586.—Krecke, A. Perikarditis adhaesiva 1 Ilerzbeutelverw.'ichsuiigen) In his Beitr. prakt. Chir, Miinch, 1934, 1S1 L—Liiwen, A, & Matthes, M. Ein weiterer Fall von rrfolgreich operierter Concretio pericardii. Deut. med. Wschr, 1928, 54: 617.—Lee, W. E, Griffith, G. C, it Farrell, H. L. Constrictive pericarditis; Pick's disease; the surgical treatment. Proc. Congr. Panpacifie Surg. Ass, 1939, 159-65.—Ljungdahl, M, A Tengwall, E. Fall von schrum- pfender Synechia pericardii mit Operation und Heiluni'. Acta chir. scand, 1925-26, 59: 480-90.- Martin, W. IL Adhesive pericarditis; treatment bv section of (lie left phrenic nerve. Virginia M. Month, 1937-38, 64: 241-7.—Martini, T, & Joselevich, M. Nuestro concepto sobre el tratamiento qui- rurgico de la sinfisis pericardica Sem. med, B. Air, 1929, 26: pt 2, 61-71.—Merle d'Aubigne. R. Sur le I raiti mini chi- rurgical de la syniph\se p.'i ieurdique. Bull. Soc. pediat. I'aiis, 1928, 26: 225-7.- Ochsner, A, A Herrmann G. R. Experi- mental surgical iclief of oxpei imentalb produced pericardial adhesions. Arch. Surg, 1929, 18: 365-85. Odelberg, A. Operated case of obUteratio pericardu. Acta chir. scand, 1931-32, 69: 378-82.—Pieri, G. Contributo alia cura chi- rurgica della pericardite adesiva. Arch. ital. chir, 1935, 41: 943-8.—Proust, R, Bascourret & Welti. La phrenicotomie dans la symphyse cardiaque. P. verb. Congr. fr. chir, 1932, 41: 287.—Rare operation restores invalids to active lives. Science News Lett, 1941, 40: 196.- Santy & Bernheim. Resection sternocostale et tesection pericardique pour sym- physe du pericarde. Lyon chir, 1938, 35: 629-35.—Scalfi", A. Su di un caso di morbo di Pick trattato con op. di Brauer e di Talma associate. Ann. ital. chir, 1938, 17: 355-84.— Schmie den, V. La cura chirurgica della pericardite adesiva. Arch, ital. chir, 1936, 44: 694. Also Arch. Soc. ital. chir, 1937, 43: 841-5. ------& Westermann, H. H. The operative manage- ment of fibrous constricting pericarditis. Surgery, 1937, 2: 350-8—Stewart, H. .1, ' 31: ]231< iM'J- YaUr' W. M. Chronic constrictive pericarditi-, chronic- caidiac compression; report of 3 cases successfully operated on. Med. Ann. District of Columbia, 1938, 7: 354- 1942 11- 19 HEART SAC 379 HEART SAC ---- Pericarditis, adhesive: Treatment. See also subheading Surgery. Noth, P. H. Pick's disease; a record of 8 years' treatment with salyrgan, ammonium nitrate, and abdominal para- centesis: report of case. Proc. Mayo Clin, 1937, 12: 513-8.— Oppenheimer, B. S, Hitzig, W. M, & Neuhof. H. Chronic constrictive pericarditis; medical and surgical aspects. J. Mount Sinai Hosp. N. York, 1940-41, 7: 270-89.—Schur, M. Probleme der adhasiven Perikarditis. Wien. klin. Wschr, 1933, 46: 1091-7. Also Erg. inn. Med. Kinderh, 1934, 47: 548- 605. ---- Pericarditis, cholesterol. Dfiniel, G, & Puder, S. Perikarditis et Pleuritis choles- terinea. Virchows Arch, 1932, 284: 853-60.—Fafius-Gordon, I. A. [Cholesterol pericarditis] Mosk. med. J, 1929, 9: 82-6 — Herzenberg, H, & Fafius-Gordon, I. A. Leber die xanthoma- tose (Cholesterin) Perikarditis. Zbl. allg. Path, 1929, 46: 97-100.—Merrill, A. J. Cholesterol pericarditis; report of a case. Am. Heart J, 1938, 16: 505-8. ---- Pericarditis, chronic. See also subheading Pericarditis, adhesive. Grote, A. *Zur Diagnose und Therapie der schwieligen Pericarditis [Gottingen] 15p. 8? Bremen, 1926. Karrenberg, L. *Ueber Erkennung und Behandlung der schwieligen Perikarditis. 26p. 21V;em. Koln, 1936. Nossack, G. [O. W.] *Zur Rontgendiagnostik der schwieligen Pericarditis. 23p. 23*4cm. Berl., 1937. Beck, C. S. The surgical treatment of pericardial scar. J. Am. M. Ass, 1931, 97: 824-31. Also repr. ------ A new conception of pericardial disorders; notes on the treat- ment of pericardial scar. Tr. Am. Ther. Soc, 1P34, 34: 83-7.— Fischer, H. Zur Frage der schwieligen Perikarditis, ihrer Erkennung und Behandlung. Schweiz. med. Wschr, 1926, 56: 489-98. -----■ Zur Durchfuhrung der Herzentrindung bei schwieliger Perikarditis. Arch. klin. Chir, 1937, 189: 548-52.—Hamazaki, Y. Comparative studies on the milk- spots, taches laiteuses, of various animals. Fol. anat. jap, 1925, 3: 243-65, 2 pl—Ingvar, S. Five c-ses of operated fibrous pericarditis. Acta med. scand, 1936, Suppl. 78, 278-92. ----- Zur Frage der Diagnostik der schwieUgen Perikarditis. Acta chir. scand, 1938, 81: 99-117. Also Lgeskr. laeger, 1938, 100: 897-906.—Koennecke, W. Die schvielige Pericarditis und ihre chirurgische Behandlung. Munch, med. Wschr, 1927, 74: 675-7.—Musser, J. H, & Herrms nn, G. R. Chronic pericarditis; the clinical and experimental aspects. J. Am. M. Ass, 1926, 87: 459-62 [Discussion] 468-70. Also repr — Nelson, A. A. Pericardial milk spots. Arch. Path, Chic, 1940, 28: 256-62.—Passler, H. W. Zur Entstehung und Be- handlung der schwieligen Perikarditis. Leit. Zschr. Chir, 1933, 241: 359-76.—Peters, J. T. Eine Erklarung des Hope- schen Phanomens bei der Fibrechia cordis. Zschr. klin. Med, 1932, 120: 408-14.—Quervain, F. de, & Schupbach, A. Leber schwielige Perikarditis und ihre chirurgische Behandlung. Schweiz. med. Wsehr, 1934, 64: 93-104.—Smith, H. L, & Willius, F. A. Pericarditis; fibrinous pericnnlitis and soldier's patches. Arch. Int. M, 1932, 50: 410- Tengwall, E. Die schwieUge Perikarditis und ihre operative Behandlung. Acta chir. scand, 1938, 81: 118-29.—Westermann, H. H. Die Operation und die Ergebnisse der Excision des Herzbeutels bei schwieUger, schrumpfender Perikarditis. Erg. Chir. Orthop, 1936, 29: 415-39.—Zaaijer, J. H, & van Houweninge Graftdijk, J. [Pericarditis fibrosa] Ned. tschr. geneesk, 1931, 75: 244.—Zdansky, E. Was leistet die Rontgenuntersuchung fiir die Diagnose der schwieligen Perikarditis? Wien. klin. Wschr, 1933, 46: 993. ---- Pericarditis: Complication. Beck, D. Pericarditis and subacute bacteria] endocarditis. J. Mount Sinai Hosp. N. York, 1941-42, 8: 364-75.—Jacobs. Pericardite et endo-pericardite chez les vieillards: thrombose de l'oreillette droite. Presse med. beige, 1868-69, 21: 309; 389.— Kelley, H. L. Pericarditis associated with impetigo herpeti- formis (?) followed by grave systemic disturbance and in- teresting pathological lesions. L. S. Nav. M. Bull, 1910, 4: 387.—Liebetanz. Glottisodem infolge traumatischer Peri- carditis. Berl. tierarztl Wschr, 1908, 732.—Marfan. La symphyse cardiaque et 1'asystolie chez l'enfant. Bull, med. Par, 1901, 15: 361-5.—Schmieden, V., & Fischer, H. Die Herzbeutelentziindung und ihre Folgezustande. Erg. Chir. Orthop, 1926, 19: 98-216. ---- Pericarditis: Diagnosis. Rosenfeld, L. *Klinische Ergebnisse betref- fend die Rontgenoskopie der Perikarditis. 30p. 8? Berl., 1909. Barnes, A. R., & Burchell, H. B. Acute pericarditis simu- lating acute coronary occlusion; a report of 14 cases. Am. Heart J, 1942, 23: 247-68.—Cohen, J. N. Diagnosis of acute pericarditis; etiology and symptoms. Med. Rec, N. Y, 1939, 150: 170-2.—Denstad, T. [Acute and chronic pericarditis, especially from the roentgenological view-point] Nord. med, 1940, 5: 542-6.—Morales Noriega, L. El diagnostico de la pericarditis. Arch, med, Madr, 1933, 36: 296-301.—Perona, P. La chimografia nelle pericarditi e loro complicanze. Clinica, Bologna, 1936, 2: 23-36.—Tarradellas, J. R. Contribucion al estudio radiologico de las pericarditis. Rev. med, B. Air, 1940, 2: 482-9.—Thomayer, J. [Diagnosis of pericarditis] Cas. lek- Cesk, 1913, 52: 1-3.—West, S. Some remarks on the diagnosis and treatment of pericarditis. Brit. M. J, 1907, 2: 1139-41.— Williamson, C. S. The diagnosis and treatment of pericarditis, the cardiac condition most frequently missed. Proc. Interst. Postgrad. M. Ass. N. America (1930) 1931. 6: 416-20, pl. ---- Pericarditis: Electrocardiography. Angyan, J, Reichenfeld, L, & Andik, I. [Electrocardio gram in pericarditis] Orv. hetil, 1939, 83: 481-6.—Bellet, S, & McMillan, T. M. Electrocardiographic patterns in acute pericarditis. Arch. Int. M, 1938, 61: 381-400.—Burchell, H. B, Barnes, A. R, & Mann, F. C. The electrocardiographic picture of experimental localized pericarditis. Collect. Papers Mayo Clin, 1938, 30: 503. Also Am. Heart J, 1939, 18: 133- 44.—Clerc, A, Bascourret, M, & Schwab, R. A propos des eiectrocardiogrammes recueillis dans le cours de la pericardite aigue. Bull. Soc. med. hop. Paris. 1932, 3. ser, 48: 292-9.— Cola, G. Osservazioni radiologiche nelle pericariditi acute e croniche (Cardiofibrechia) Radiol, med, Milano, 1935, 22: 125-46.—Haager, B. The electrocardiogram in pericarditis; a summary. Sc. Commun. Bain. Inst. Bad-Nauheim, 1935, No. 2, 10-4.—Herles, F. [Electrocardiogram in pericarditis] Cas. lek. Cesk, 1937, 76: 743-7, 3 pl—Herrmann, G, & Schwab, E. H. Some experimental and clinical electro-cardio- graphic observations on R-S-T and T changes in pericarditis. Tr. Ass. Am. Physicians, 1934, 49: 229-44.—Herrmann, G, Schwab, E. H. [et al] Electrocardiographic changes in acute and chronic pericarditis in the goat. Proc. Soc. Exp. Biol, N. Y, 1934, 31: 1050-3.— Holzmann, M. Caracteristiques electrocardiographiques de la pericardite. Rev. med. Suisse rom, 1935, 55: 830.------Elektrokardiographische Befunde bei Perikarditis. Zschr. klin. Med, 1935, 128: 731-44. Also Helvet. med. acta, 1936, 3: 249-57.—Izzo, R. A, Ferradas, J. B, & Laplace. J. M. Pericarditis; su curva electrocardio- grafica. Sem. med, B. Air, 1936, 43: pt 2, 835-9.—Morland, A, & Osborne, J. Pericarditis associated with R-T deviation without tamponade. Lancet, Lond, 1938, 2: 1522.—Noth, P. H, & Barnes, A. R. Electrocardiographic changes associated with pericarditis. Arch. Int. M, 1940, 65: 291-320. ------ The electrocardiogram in pericarditis. Mod. Concepts Card. Dis, 1938, 7: No. 5, 1.—Peel, A. A. F. On the occurrence of the so-called coronary T wave in electrocardiograms from cases of pericarditis. Glasgow M. J, 1934, 122: 149-66—Raskina- Braude, M. V. [Electrocardiographic observations in peri- carditis; paracentesis of the pericardium; convalescence] Pediatria, Moskva, 1941, No. 2, 69-74.—Roberts, C. P., & Fulton. F. T. Progressive electrocardiographic changes in pericarditis. N. England J. M, 1938, 219: 798-802.—Schon- dorf, T. Ueber das Elektrokardiogramm bei Perikarditis. Verh. Deut. Ges. inn. Med, 1936, 48. Kongr, 350-4.—Vander Veer, J. B, & Norris, R. F. The electrocardiographic changes in acute pericarditis: a clinical and pathological study. Am. Heart J, 1937, 14: 31-50. Also J. Am. M. Ass.. 1939, 113: 1483-7. Also Rev. radiol. fisioter. Chic, 1940, 7: 33-40.— Waldorp, C. P., & Genijovich, S. La electrocai'iliojjrafla en las pericarditis. Actas Congr. nac. med, Rosario, 1934, 5: pt 4, 595-602.—Winternitz, M, & Langendorf, R. Das Elektro- kardiogramm der Perikarditis. Acta med. scand, 1938, 94: 141; 274. ---- Pericarditis: Etiology. See also primary diseases as Heart rheuma- tism; Tuberculosis, &c. Bing.H. I. Epidemical pericarditis. Acta med. scand, 1933, 80: 29-33. Also Ugeskr. laeger, 1933, 95: 401.—Bozhovski, V. G. [Malarial pericarditis with probable aortic stenosis] Prakt. vrach, 1911, 10: 545.—Butsch, W. L. Acute pericarditis as a postoperative complication. Proc. Mayo Clin, 1937, 12: 737-41.—Corbus, B. C, jr. Genesis of pericarditis; a review and discussion of 300 cases. Arch. Path, Chic, 1940, 30: 635. Also Proc. Inst. M. Chicago, 1940-41, 13: 93.—Fischer, E, & Kaiserling, H. Die experimentelle lymphogene allergische Perikarditis, Lymphangitis des Herzens. Verh. Deut. path. Ges. (1938) 1939, 31: 437-58.—Gerke, A. A. [Etiology of pericarditisl Klin, med, Moskva, 1929, 7: 1597-615 Also Virchows Arch, 1930, 278: 1-22.—Goinard, P. Les peri- cardites a pneumococques. Rev. chir. Par, 1936, 55: 36-70.— Gotlib, D. [Acute idiopathic pericarditis] Prakt. vrach, 1908, 7: 389.—Hambursin. De la perihepatite consecutif comme cause de pericardite et d'affection organique du coeur. Presse med. beige, 1868-69, 21: 13; 21; 30.—Hassman i, W. [Causes of pericarditis; data based on autopsies] Polskis arch. med. wewn, 1938, 16: 320-40.—Huard, P. Pericardite et abces du foie. Bull. Soc. path, exot. Par, 1939, 32: 623-31—Impera- tori, C. J. Pericarditis as a terminal lesion in mediastinitis: HEART SAC 380 HEART SAC report of a case, following the inhalation of a foreign body in the bronchus and accompanied by spontaneous emphvsema. Ann. Otol Rhinol, 1933, 42: 923-6.—Kataropulo, A. Amoben- perikarditis. Arch. Schiffs Tropenhyg, 1932, 36: 544.— Krauspe. Ein Fall von mykotischer Perikarditis. Verh. Deut. path. Ges, 1926, 21: 427-34. Also Zbl. allg. Path, 1926, 37: 555.—Lazeanu, E., Pavel, I, & Mavromati, M. La pericardite au cours de 1'endocardite maligne a evolution lente. C. rend. Congr. fr. med. (1927) 1928-29, 19. Congr, 106— Mannkopff. E. Pericarditis sicca als Komplikation der Ervthrodermia desquamativa. Arch. Kinderh, 1929-30, 89: 121-4.— Selig- man, B, & Lederer, M. Acute pericarditis; following a second- ary infection of the lymph node of a Ghon tubercle. N. York State J. M, 1940, 40: 130-2.—Smith, H. L, & Willius, F. A. Pericardiiis; terminal pericarditis. Arch. Int. M, 1932, 50 415. ---- Pericarditis, experimental. Beraarbeo, E. Anatomia patologica sperimentale delle pericarditi. Ann. ital chir, 1934, 13: 1033-67.—Carerj, L. Pericardia sperimentali. Clin.chir, Milano, 1937,40:305-41.— Herrmann, G, & Musser, J. H. Experimental pericarditis. Am. Heart J, 1928-29, 4: 268-79.—Horio, S. Experimental pericarditis, resorption of bacilli, especially from the peri- cardial cavity. Jap. J. M. Sc, 1934-36, 4: Surg. &c, 245.— Musser, J. H, & Herrmann, G. R. Experimental pericajditis. Tr. Ass. Am. Physicians. 1928, 43: 23-30.—Shipley, A. M, & Horine, C. F. Experimental pericarditis. Arch. Surg , 1929, 18: 386-402.—Tournade, A, Torreilles, J, & Chardon, G. Des modifications du rythme cardiaque observees au cours de l'epanchement pericardique experimental; mecanisme de leur production. C. rend. Soc. biol, 1939, 131: 332-5. ---- Pericarditis, exudative. See also subheading Hydropericardium. Archambault, P. *Quelques considerations sur un cas de p6ricardite rhumatismale a 6panche- ment retro-cardiaque simulant une pleur6sie gauche [Paris] 38p. 8! Angers, 1921. Esvan, M. *Etude des modifications des complexes ventriculaires eiectriques dans le cours des pericardites a epanchement. 107p. 24cm. Par., 1939. Herbert, E., & Feller, A. Stauungstypen bei Kreislaufstorungen mit besonderer Beriick- sichtigung der exudative Perikarditis; eine anatomisehe experimentelle und klinische Unter- suchung. 232p. 8? Wien, 1926. Tarlowsky, L. P. *Driisenschlauchahnliche Bildungen im perikarditischen Exsudate. 42p. 8? Ziir., 1908. Almeida Prado, A. de. Sobre a pericardite exsudativa. In his Lie. conf. clin. med, S. Paulo, 1934, 143-70.—Arana, R., Kreutzer, R, & Aguirre, R. S. El dngulo cardiohepdtico en las pericarditis con derrame. Arch, argent, pediat, 1939, 12: 44-8.—Arrillaga, F. C, Mordeglia, M, & Taquini, H. C. Distintos aspectos de la pericarditis con derrame. Rev. As. med. argent, 1940, 54: 773-82.—Babes, A. A. [Pericarditis with enormous effusion] Spitalul, 1913, 33: 492-5.—Boller, R. Fall von chronischer Pericarditis exsudativa. Wien. med. Wshr, 1927, 77: 226.—Bulochkina, L. M. [Exudative peri- carditis in infants] Sovet. pediat , 1935, No. 8, 92-5.—Calvert, W. J. Pulsus paradoxus in pericarditis with effusion. J. Am. M. Ass, 1907, 48: 1168-71. ------ Position of the heart in pericarditis with effusion. Bull Johns Hopkins Hosp, 1907, 18: 403-9.—Cassaet, E. Un noufrel exemple d'encoche de Sibson sans pericardite. Rev. gen. clin. ther, 1902, 16: 801.— Caughey, J. L, jr. A case of pericarditis with effusion; studies of venous pressure changes. Bull N. York Acad. M, 1937, 13: 1-10.—Chavigny, M. Pericardite avec epanchement. Paris m d, 1931, 79: 204-6.—Coelho, E. Les anomalies electro- cardiographiques de l'epanchement pericardiaque. Bull. Soc med. hop. Paris, 1932, 3. ser, 48: 285-92.—Comer, M. C. Acute pericarditis with effusion, a sequel to sinusitis. South- west. M, 1927, 11: 310.—Courmont, P., & Gerest. Peri- cardite latente; persistence des bruits du cceur malgre un epanchement de 1,000 grammes. Bull. Soc. med. hop. Lyon, 1909, 8: 143-5. Also Lyon med, 1909, 112: 569-71.—Cuatre- casas, J. Contribuci6n al estudio del sindrome de Pins. Ar« medica, Barcel, 1933, 9: 129-37, 4 pl—Dell'Acqua, G, & Freundlich, J. Leber sackformige Abkapselung eines peri- karditischen Exsudates. Zschr. Kreislaufforsch, 1928, 20: 703-11.—Donini, G. Segno stetoacustico di piccolo versamento pericardico (nota di semeiotica) Gior. cUn. med, 1926. 7: 658-63.—Elias, H. Die Perikarditis exsudativa. Wien klin Wschr, 1928, 41: 340-4. Also Praxis, Bern, 1929, 18: H. 38, !; 3.—Feller, A. Wie entsteht und verliiuft die Pericarditis exsudativa und welche Ausgange derselben kennen wir? Wien klin. Wschr, 1931, 44: 1444. Also Aerztl. Prax, Wien, 1932, 6: 311.—Ferreira, J. Diagnostic des pericardites latentes avec petit epanchement. C. rend. Congr. internat. med, 1906 15 Congr, sect. 5, 421. Also Rev. gin. chn. ther, 1907, 21: 215.— I rommel, E, & Eghiayan. Remarques sur l'image radiologique le la pericardite k epanchement avant et aptes la ponction - varuatrice. Rev. med. Suisse rom, 1926, 46: 105-10.— Glinkin. M. I, & Ershon, .1. A. [1 )iagnosis and roentgenological dynamics of exudative pern ardit is] Klin, med, Moskva, 1940, 18: No. 7, 102-11, pl— Hebert, G. Ln cas de pericardite avec epanchement sero-fibrineux. I'nion med. Canada, 1941, 70: 1309-13.—Heckmann. K. Los sfntomas del derrame pericar- dico. Dfa med, B. Air, 1937, 9: 402 5—Jedlicka, J. [Rare physical cardiologic signs in treatment by pneumothoiax; Rotch's sign in exudative pcricaiditis] Cas. lek. CesL, I9:i_' 71: 68-70, 2 pl Kamenetzky, P. M., & Rabinowitsch. J. s. Zur Symptomatologie der Pericarditis exsudativa. Munch med. Wschr., 1926, 73: 478.—Kienbock, R. On a rare issue of pericarditis exsudativa; combination of concretion and cyst- formation. Brit. J. Radiol, 1927, 32: B. I. R. Sect, 352-4.— Kurt, L. [Svmptome der exsudativen Perioarditis] Mitt Ges. inn. Med. Kinderh. Wien, 1909, 8: 180.—Levine, S. A, & Gevalt, F. C, jr. The significance of Ewart's sign. Tr. Acm. Par., 1937. Also Ann. Anat. path. Par, 1937, 14: 37-49. Gritty, J. G. *A propos d'un cas de peri- cardite tuberculeuse hemorragique. 49p. 8? Par., 1931. Kugler, H. *Ein Fall von Pericarditis haemorrhagica carcinomatosa. 16p. 8? Miinch., 1935. Stammler, F. *Ein Fall von hamorrhagischer Pericarditis. 21p. 8? Munch., 1906. Bouchut, L, & Levrat, M. Pericardite hemorragique au cours dune endocardite infectieuse. Lyon m6d, 1930, 145: 558.—1Capogrossi, A. Pericardite emorragica da pneumococco; paracentesi del pericardio; esiti. Boll. Soc. eustach, 1926, 24: 39-50. Also Gazz. med. Roma, 1926, 52: 162; 182—Melnikov- Rasvedenkov, N. Leber eine besondere Form der hamor- rhagischen Perikarditis beim Menschen: xanthomatose lym- phangiektatische Perikarditis. Virchows Arch, 1930, 275: 688-97.—Nicaise, V. Pericardite hemorrhagique. Bull. Soc. anat. Paris, 1899, 74: 680-4.—Tixier, L, & Bardin, P. Dis- cussion etiologique concernant un cas de pericardite hemor- ragique rapidement curable. Arch. med. enf, 1935, 38: 197- 205.—Vincent & Ardin-Delteil. Pericardite hemorragique et purulente primitive k pneumocoques. Bull. nted. Algerie, 1908, 19: 285. ---- Pericarditis, juvenile. Klarnet, J. I. *Les pleuro-pericardites a pneumocoques de la premiere enfance. 57p. 8? Par., 1931. Pfaehler, P. *Ueber Pericarditis im Kindes- alter; nach Beobachtungen im Zurcher Kinder- Spital 1876-97 [Zurich] 97p. 8? Bern, 1897. Baumel, L. Pericardite aigue chez l'enfant. Rev. gin. clin. ther, 1911, 35: 369. ------ Quelques considerations cUniques sur la pericardite aigue chez 1 enfant. Medecine, Par, 1920-21, 2: 843.—bovairo, D, jr. On acute pericarditis in children. Tr. Am. Pediat. Soc, 1910, 22: 260-78. Also M. & S. Rep. Presbyterian Hosp, N. Y, 1912, 9: 61-82, pl— Job, Levy & Morlot. Endo-pericardite du nouveau-ne. Bull. Soc. obst. gyn. Paris, 1917, lb: 171.—Navarro, J. C, & de Alzaga, a. Pericarditis. Area, argent, pediat, 1932, 3: 408.— Navarro, J. C, & Bereterviue, E. Sobre 2 casos de pericarditis en lactantes. Sem. med, B. Air, 1922, 29: 27.—Reynolds, E. R. Case of pericarditis of unrecognized etiology; vitamin Bi therapy. Arch. Pediat, N. Y, 1939, 56: 158-68.—Wolff, J. Zur Diagnose der Perikarditis im SiiugUngsalter. Kinderarztl Prax, 1938, 9: 59. ---- Pericarditis: Manifestation. See also Heart sound, and its subheadings. Aubry, C, Routier, D, & Lenegre. Valeur diagnostique des signes de pericardite. Monde m6d, 1932, 42: 587-90.— £ <7 ,'n™ f« Cardiohepatic angle. Johns Hopkins Hosp. Bull, 1908 19: 143-5.—Capps, J. A. Pericardial pain; an experimental and clinical study. Tr. Ass. Am. Physicians, 1927, 42: 243-54.------ The interpretation of pain in peri- carditis and pleuro-pericarditis. Memphis M. J, 1930, 7: 1_3.-—Cohen, J. N. Physical signs in the diagnosis of acute pericarditis. Med. Rec, N. Y, 1940, 151: 22-30.—Galla- vardin, L. Douleurs angineuses et pericardite aigue; peri- cardite a debut angineux. Lyon med, 1928, 141: 541-50.— Gardere & Correard. Pericardite aigue avec syndrome pseudo- pleuretique axillaire. Ibid, 151-5.—Giannoni, A. Sulla sintomatologia dolorosa delle pericarditi. Riv. clin. med Fir, 1934, 35: 271-311.—Golden, G. M. Pericarditis; some clinical aspects. Hahneman. Month, 1927, 62: 593-8.— Greengard, J, & Hoffman, S. J. Pericarditis simulating an acute condition of the abdomen. Arch. Suit;.. 1933, 26: 623-32. Also repr.—Jampolsky, L. D, & Krys, 1. I. [Sympto- matology of pericarditis] Klin, med, Moskva, 1933, 11: 100-3.—Katz, G. 1. [Symptomatology of pericarditis] Ibid, 912-5.—Kossmann, C. E, & Schneider, J. Potential varia- tions of extremities and of precordium in pericarditis. Proc. Soc. Exp. Biol, N. Y, 1937-38, 37: 213.—Molinari, G. Peri- cardite e sintoma dolore. Riforma med, 1934, 50: 1177.— Mouriquand, G, & Roubier, C. Eclat clangoreux du second bruit au foyer pulmonaire oomme signe precoce de pericardite (signe de Josserand) Lyon med, 1907, 109: 352-6.—Riesman, D. Pericarditis; its symptoms and diagnosis. Am. J. M. Sc, 1904, 128: 466-73.—Rubin, E. L, & Pappworth, M. H. Symp- tomless pericarditis; report of two cases. Brit. J. Radiol, 1938, 11: 671-5.—Wynter, W. E. Absence of abdominal respiratory movement as an indication of pericarditis. Proc. R. Soc. M, Lond, 1910-11, 4: Med. Sect, 40-50. Also Polyclinic, Lond, 1913, 17: 71-5. ---- Pericarditis: Pathology. Neussel, H. *Ein Beitrag zur Kenntnis der Pericarditis. 60p. 8? Bresl., 1903. Babes, V. La sous-pericardite. C. rend. Soc. biol, 1908, 64: 509-11.—Bernard, A. Les formes angineuses de la peri- cardite aigue. J. sc. med. Lille, 1924, 42: 244-9.—Branch, C. F. A brief review of the essential pathology of pericarditis. N. England J. M, 1933, 208: 771-3.—Brisranti, A. Nuove vedute sulla patogenesi dello scompenso circolatorio di tipo peri- carditico. Fol. med. Nap, 1939, 25: 28-37.—Curschmann, H. Pericarditis sicca et exsudativa. Jahrkurs. arztl Fortbild, 1939, 30: H. 2, 11-20.—Davis, N. S. The effects of pericarditis on the heart. J. Am. M. Ass, 1906, 47: 1429-32. Also repr — Pyrah, L. N, & Pain, A. B. Acute pericarditis: a review of 215 autopsies. J. Path. Bact, Cambr, 1933, 37: 233-41. ---- Pericarditis, rheumatic. See Heart rheumatism, Pericardium. ---- Pericarditis, suppurative [Pyopericardium] Simon, K. C. I. *Ueber einen Fall von Pyo- pericarditis [Leipzig] 8p. 8? [Zeulenroda] 1921. Zoltkowski, J. *Un cas de pericardite purulente a bacilles de Pfeiffer. 40p. 22^ cm. Lausanne, 1936. Acuna, M, & Bettinoti, S. I. Pericarditis purulenta en una nifia de 19 meses. Prensa med. argent, 1934-35, 21: 251-5.— Adams, R, & Polderman, H. Suppurative pericarditis. N. England J. M, 1941, 225: 897-902.—Adye-Curran, W. J. P. Gunshot wound, pericardium; pyo-pericardium with gas in- fection. J. R. Army M. Corps, 1918, 30: 599.—Albrecht, P. Ueber akute eitrige Perikarditis. Beitr. klin. Chir, 1927, 141: 193-214.—Arntzenius, A. K. W. [Septic pericarditis; case] Ned. tschr. geneesk, 1930, 74: 957.—Attix, F. F. Purulent pericarditis due to pneumococcus, with case report. Tr. West. Surg. Ass, 1937, 47: 241-60 [Discussion] 281-6. Also West. J. Surg, 1938, 46: 132-9.—Bacaloglu, C, Georgescu, G, & Dumitrescu, D. [Purulent, pneumococcic pericarditis] Spitalul, 1932, 52: 341.—Basnuevo, J. G. Diagn6stico bac- ieriol6gico de un caso de pericarditis purulenta a neumobacilo de Friedlander. Vida nueva, Habana, 1933, 32: 263-5, ch.— Uattaglia, M. Pericardite purulenta da stafilococco piogeno aureo e diplococco lanceolate (Frankel) Gior. internaz. sc. med, 1908, n. ser, 30: 892-5.—Baumeyer, S. Ueber Peri- carditis purulenta mit stenoseartigem Aivfangsbefund als 1'eilerscheinung einer Infiuenza-Allgemeininfektion. Mschr. Kinderh, 1932, 55: 123-33.—Beattie, W. J. H. M. A case of suppurative pericarditis, with recovery. S. Barth. Hosp. J, Lond, 1928-29, 3b: 105.—Bigi, S. La pericardite purulenta nelle infezioni intratoraciche. Ann. ital. chir, 1939, 18: 076-86.— Bogdan, G. Un cas de pericardite purulente avec enorme epanchement k la suite de blessure par arme k feu. J. med. Pans, 1914, 2. ser, 26: 335.—Bolton, E. L. Two cases of suppurative pericarditis. Wisconsin M. J, 1933, 32: 151-3 —Bunch, G. H. Suppurative pericarditis. Tr. South. Surg. Ass, 1935, 4,1: 419-34.—Gnirie, J. L. Pericardite puru- lente k pneuuio-bacille chez un enfant nouveau-ne a terme. HEART SAC 382 HEART SAC Bull Soc. obst. gyn. Paris, 1907, 10: 275-83— Conklin, C. B. Report of a case of seropurulent meningococcic pericarditis, panophthalmitis and parotiditis complicating epidemic cere- brospinal meningitis. Internat. Clin, 1939, n. ser. 2, 2: 256-8, pl (vetkovic, D. [Case of cold abscess of the peri- cardium wit 11 terminal miliarization] Voj. san. glasnik, 1937, 8: 497-500.—Davis, H. Purulent pericarditis: case report. Virginia M. Month.. 1934, 61: 539.—Del Carril, M. J, Pflaum, A, & Dechessarri, R. Pericarditis purulenta a neumococos en un lactante. Hev. As. med. argent, 1935, 49: 55-61.— De Sanctis, A. G. Purulent pericarditis; report of a case Arch. Pediat, N. Y, 1926, 43: 726-31.—Dickinson, E. H Suppurative pericarditis. Hahneman. Month, 1938. 73: 371-8.—Dube, J. E. Pericardite supputee et pleutesie puru- lente enkvstee de la pievre droite. Lnion m.ed. Canada, 1938, 67: 131-3.—Eliot, E., jr. Suppurative pericarditis. M. & S. Rep. Presbyterian lisp, N. Y, 1908, 8: 79-100.—Evans, R. L. Acute suppurative pericarditis and staphylococcemia. Guthrie Clin. Bull, 1939-40, 9: 151-7.—Finney, J. O, & Morgan. J. O. Acute purulent pericarditis; report of a case. J. M. A.-*. Alabama, 1939-40, 9: 81-5—Gliieker, J. [Abscess anil pneumatosis of the pericardium] Lwow. tygodn. lek, 1913, 8: 200-2.—Hallock, D. H. Empyema of the pericardium; pyop.ricardium. N. York State J. M, 1937, 37: 372-7.— Heidenreich. A. J, Sei, M. del, & Echevarria, F. Pericarditis latero-posteiior purulenta apitetica. Rev. As. med. argent, 1937, 51 : 581.—Heyl, J. H. Acute suppurative pericarditis. Ann. Surg, 1930, 104: 365-72—Hoff, H. L. M. van der [Suppurative pericarditis in a child] Ned. tschr. geneesk, 1930, 74: 14 80-2, pl.—Imerwol, V. Despre pericardita puru- lenta la copu. Bull. Soc. mod. natur. Jassy, 1910, 24: 68-83.— Jobin, J. B. Pvopneumopericardite; observation. Laval med, 1938, 3: 315-9, pl—Kretschmer, W. Pericarditis fibrino-punilenta subacute. Med. Klin, Berl, 1911, 7: 74.— Laird, R. Acute suppurative pericarditis. Proc. R. Soc. M, Lond, 193* 39, 32: Clin. Sect, 443.—Langer, G. Ein Fall von Pyopiieumoporikard. Beitr. Klin. Tuberk, 1930-31, 76: 597-602.—Lilienthal, H. Suppurative pericarditis with calci- fication uf tie pericardium and epicardium. J. Mount Sinai Hosp. N. York, 1937-38, 4: 1-6.—Lozano, R. Pericarditis purulenta. Clin, mod, Zpracoza, 1910, 9: 275-81, pl— Macfarlane, J. W. Acute suppurative pericarditis. Lancet, Lond, 1937, 2: 79.—Machado, O. Sobre im caso de peri- carditis purulenta a iiciimoba'-ilo de Frlillaniler. Crim. med. quir. Habana, 1932, 58: 53-7. 2 pl.— McNamara, P. P, & Younan, T. Acute fill inopurulent pericarditis. J. Iowa M. Soc, 1935, 25: 453-5.—Madden, L. E. Purulent pericarditis. J. S. Carolina M. Ass, 1936, 32: 5.5-61.—Malec, J. P, & Midelfart, P. A. Purulent pericarditis; report of a case with unusual complications. Am. J. Surg, 1940, 49: 351-5.— Massabuau, Guibal & Laux. Pericardite supputee, complica- tion dune ostedmi elite de la handle. Montpellier med, 192(1 48: 380.—Mirks. R. H. Purulent pericarditis. Irish J. M. Sc, 1937, ser. 0. 306-8.--Miller, E. M. Suppurative pericarditis: report of a case. .1. Am. M. Ass, 1932, 98: 873-5. Also Surg. Clin. N. America, 1932, 12: 1275.—Mints, V. M. [Purulent pericarditis] Khir. arkh. Velyaminova, 1911, 27: 690.—Morin, P. Ln cas de pericardite purulente simulant une affection abdominale. Lnion med. Canada, 1934, 63: 39-41.—Nikolaev, G. F. Du role des abces du myocarde dans la pathogenie des pericardites supputees. Presse med, 1937, 45: 920-8. Also Sovet, med, 1938, 38-41.—Peterson, E. W. Suppurative pericarditis; report of 3 cases. Arch. Surg, 1928, 16: 366-79.—Piasecki, M. Pericardite purulenta durante il decorso degli empiemi nei bambini. Rinasc. med, 1936, 13: 695.—Purks. W. K. The occurrence of a coronary T-wave in purulent pericarditis. South. M. J, 1931, 24: 1032-4 — Ramond, L. Pericardite purulente k pneumocoques. Presse med, 1928, 36: 763.—Rayburn, T. H. Suppurative peri- carditis. Mississippi Doctor, 1938-39, 16: No. 2, 13.—Sher- wood, M. W. Suppurative pericarditis: with report of a case. Med. Pec, Houston, 1926, 20: 5-7.—Shipley, A. M, & Win- slow, N. Suppurative pericarditis. Tr. Am. Surg. Ass, 1927, 45: 286-91.—Siegenbeek van Heukelom [Pneumococcal pyemia; empyema of the pericardium] Geneesk. tschr. Ned. Indie, 1940, 80: 2656.—Staehelin, R. Pericarditis purulenta mit Elektrokardiogramm. Helvet. med. acta, 1938, 5: 566.— Steven, J. L. Case of purulent pericarditis. Tr. Med. Chir. Soc. Glasgow, 1902, 3: 23-5.—Suppurative pericarditis. Med. ,!. Australia. 1939, 2: 549.—Thomas, T. M. A case of purulent pericarditis following acute osteomyelitis. Arch. Dis. Childh, Lond, 1928, 4: 07-75.—Tizon & Leroy. A propos d'un cas de pericardite supputee. Bull. Sot. eiectroradiol med. France, 1939, 27: 269-72.—Viana, O. Pericardite purulenta stafilo- coccica in puerpera. Rifoima med, 1937, 53: 1049.—Walker, M. A. Purulent pericarditis. Texas J. M, 1933, 28: 679-82.— White, R. J. Purulent pericarditis: a report of 7 cases. South. M. J, 1932, 25: 364-71.—\\ bitney, H. B. Purulent peri- cardial effusion; report of a case in connection with remarks on the circulatory disturbances of the grip. Denver M Times, 1907-8, 27: 320-4— W illiamson, E. G. Purulent peri- carditis in childhood. Ann. Surg, 1927, 85: 659-67.—Wolff, S. Empyema necessitatis pericardii nebst Bemerkungen iiber die Perikarditis im Kindesalter. Klin. 'Wschr, 1935, 14: 1242-4.— Wolfson, M, & Sharp, J. C. Acute suppurative pericarditis, with an initial leukemoid blood picture. California West M 1940, 52: 116-20. ---- Pericarditis, suppurative: Treatment. See also subheading Surgery. Malo, L. *La voic xiphoidienne dans le traitement des pericardites purulent.es. 79p. 24cm. Par., 1930. Adshead, G. P. Purulent pericarditis treated by drainage. J. R. Nav. M. Serv, 1926, 12: 57-9.- Albrecht, P. Zwei Fiillo von Pcrikardiotomie wegen akuter eitriger Perikarditis. Wien. klin. Wschr, 1927, 40: 365. Also Wien. med. Wschr, 1927, 77: 390.—Alexander, E. G. Suppurative pericarditis from the surgical viewpoint. Ann. Surg, 1928, 88: 801-22.—Barberi. S. Sulla terapia. della pericardite purulenta neU'infariziii. Med. inf, Roma. 1937, 8: 97-107, ch. Also Gazz. osp, 1937. 58: 683-5.--Benhamou, E, & Goinard, P. Pericardite purulente k pneumocoques guerie par pericarilotomie epigastrique. Presse med, 1932, 40: 1504. Bigger, I. A. Suppurative peri- carditis with a report of 8 cases treated surgically. South. M, J, 1937, 30: 104-71. ------ The treatment of suppurative pericarditis. Surgerv, 1937, 2: 128-30. ------• Suppurative pericarditis. Tr. South. Surg. Ass, 1938, 51: 123-30. Also Ann. Surg, 1939, 109: 763-70.—Billings, A. E. Suppurative pericarditis; pericardiotomy. Surg. Clin. N. America, 1932, 12: 1517-33.—Bisgard, J. D. Pyopericarditis; an analysis of cases treated by pericardiotomy. Am. J. Surg, 1932, n. ser, 17: 1-15. Also repr.—Bowers, L. G. Pericardotomy for pyoperi- cardium. Arch. Surg, 1929, 19: 301-8.—Brenizer, A. G. Early pericardotomy in purulent pericarditis. South. M. & S, 1929, 91: 468-71.—Bueermann, W. H. Suppurative peri- carditis; a surgical consideration with case report. Northwest M, 1932, 31: 290-6.— Bume, G. F. Leber Spiilungsbehandlung der eitrigen Perikarditis. Wien. klin. Wschr, 1936, 49: 307.— Bunch, G. H. Suppurative pericarditis. Am. J. Surg, 1935, 28: 613-28.—Cottam, G. Suppurative pericarditis with description of a case in which drainage was made through a new approach. Tr. West. Surg. Ass, 1932, 42: 226-39. Also West, J. Surg, 1933, 41: 86-90.------Suppurative pericarditis and its surgical drainage. J. Am. M. Ass, 1937, 109: 1926.— Edington, G. H. Incision and drainage of the pericardium in a case of purulent pericarditis associated with abscess of the thigh. Glasgow M. J, 1908, 69: 128-34.—Garcia, M, Souza Paiva, R, & Sardinha, J. Pericardite purulenta por Staphy- lococcus aureus no curso de septicemia estafilococica; cura pela sulfamida-crisoidina por via oral e injecao intrapericardica. Rev. med. mun, Rio, 1941, 1: 78-84.—Gertzenstein, S, & Kreutzer, R. Curva eiectrica de un caso de pericarditis puru- lenta ptiuzado y pericardiotomizado. Sem. med, B. Air, 1934, 41: 1096-100.—Grimault, L. Pericardite purulente a pneumo- coques; pericardotomie; guerison. Bull. Soc. nat. chir. Par, 1929, 55: 1290-5. Also Rev. med. est, 1930, 58: 261- 71.—Guiou, N. M. Pericardiotomy for septic pericarditis. Canad. M. Ass. J, 1939, 41: 163-6.—Harloe, R. F. Suppura- tive pericarditis; new surgical treatment of purulent pericarditis with review of 2 cases. Long Island M. J, 1928, 22: 633-40.— Herzog, A. Spontanheilung eines Pyoperikards. Med. Klin, Berl, 1933, 29: 644.—Iversen, J. J. [Treatment of purulent pleurisy and pericarditis by proteolytic antiferment] Khir. arkh. Velyaminova, 1911, 27: 913-5.—Leitner, F. [Treatment of purulent pericarditis (case of purulent pericarditis treated and cured with optochin)] Cluj. med, 1932, 13: 209-15.— Leitner, P. Leber einen durch Optochinbehandlung geheilten Fall von eitriger Pneumokokken-Perikarditis. Jahrb. Kinderh, 1932, 3. F, 86: 71-81.—Loucks, H. H. Suppurative pericardi- tis; report of 2 cases drained by the posterior route. Arch. Surg., 1929, 18: 852-67— Mints, V. M. [Surgical treatment of puru- lent pericarditis] Khirurgia, Moskva, 1912, 31: 434-42.— Moore, R. L. Posterior drainage in suppurative pericarditis. Ann. Surg, 1935, 102: 980-8.—Niculescu, M. [Purulent peri- carditis; case of purulent metapneumonic pericardiomediastini- tis; operation and convalescence] Rev. st. med, Bucur, 1939, 2S: 1138-49.—Piradov, R. B. Sluchal pericardiotomU po povodu pyopericardit'a. Tr. protok. Imp. Kavkazsk. Med. Obsh, 1909-10, 46: 279-82.—Pyrah, L. N, & Pain, A. B. Acute suppurative pericarditis; 2 cases successfully treated by operation. Lancet, Lond, 1933, 1: 905-8— Ramond, L, & Weill-Spire, R. Guerison d'une pericardite purulente a pneumo- coques par pericardotomie epigastrique. Bull Soc. med. h6p. Paris, 1927, 3. ser, 51: 1163-6.—Ross, D. E. Suppurative pericarditis. Am. J. Surg, 1939, 43: 134-7.—Sennels, A. [Operative treatment in suppurative pericarditis] Hospitals- tidende, 1934, 77: 220-5.—Shipley, A. M. Suppurative pericarditis; late results and methods of drainage. Tr. South. Surg. Ass, 1935, 48: 58-65. Also Ann. Surg, 1936, 103: 698-705. ------■ Pericardiotomy for pyopericardium. In Cyclop. Med. (Piersol-Bortz) Phila, 1939, 3: 971-4. -----■ & Winslow, N. Purulent pericarditis; report of 5 cases in which treatment was by pericardiotomv, and review of the literature from April 30, 1927, to Jan. 1, 1934. Arch. Surg, 1935, 31: 375-94. Also repr.—Steven, J. Q. Case of purulent peri- carditis in which paracentesis pericardU was performed. Tr. Med. Chir. Soc. Glasgow, 1902, 3: 25-31.—Strieder, J. W., & Sandusky, W. R. Pericardiostomy for suppurative pericardi- tis; a report concerning 10 new cases and 28 cases from the literature. N. England J. M, 1941, 225: 317-26.—Train, I. P. Acute suppurative pericarditis compUcating septicemia; report I of a case with recovery after operation. J. Mount Sinai Hosp. HEART SAC 383 HEART SAC N York 1938-39, 5: 45-8.—Trojan, E. [Purulent pericarditis and its treatment] Orv. hetil, 1938, 82: 1212.—Truesdale, P. E. Low pericardiotomy for acute suppurative pericarditis; report of 2 cases and 24 new cases from the literature. N. England J. M, 1933, 208: 671-80.—Westerborn, A. Operierter Fall von eitriger Perikarditis. Lpsala lak. foren. forh, 1926, n. F, 31: 609-22, 2 pl.—Wilensky, A. O, & Lilienthal, H. Pericardiostomy for acute purulent pericarditis. Am. J. Surg, 1936, 33: 118-23. Also repr.—Winslow, N, & Shipley. A. M. Pericardiotomy for pyopericardium: review of literature to May 1927, and report of 10 new cases. Arch. Surg, 1927, 15: 317-50. Also repr.—Zeno, A. Resultado final de una operaci6n por pericarditis purulenta. Bol. Soc. cir. B. Aires, 1927, 11: 452-6, pl—Zhakov, M. P. [Surgical therapy of purulent peri- carditis] Vest, khir, 1931, 24: 26-30. ---- Pericarditis, traumatic. Sec also subheading Injury. Auerbach, B. Pericarditis caseosa und Lnfall. Miinch. med. Wschr, 1913, 60: 1829.—Becker. Zur Pericarditis traumatica beim Rinde. Deut. tierarztl Wschr, 1921, 29: 545.—Davenport, C. Traumatic pericarditis; a case with unusual features. Vet. Rec, Lond, 1941, 53: 452.—Eilmann. Eine seltene Form der Pericarditis traumatica. Berl. tierarztl Wschr, 1924, 40: 204.—Ferguson, T. H. Traumatic pericardi- tis of the ox. North Am. Vet, 1920, 1: 8-13. ------ Success- ful operation for traumatic pericarditis. Vet. Med, Chicago, 1922,17:279.—Fyrth, W. Traumatic pericarditis. Vet. Rec, Lond, 1929, 9: 1134.—Gerke, A. A. [Traumatic pericarditis] Ter. arkh, 1934, 12: 173-7.—Giovannoli, G. Ln caso collet- tivo di pericardite traumatica. N. ercolani, 1907, 12: 193; 209.—Gottardi, G. Osservazioni sul cosidetto sintomo della vena giugolare nella diagnosi della pericardite traumatica. Profilassi, 1932, 5: 90-8.—Graefe, H. C. Traumatic peri- carditis in a bull. Vet. Med, Chic, 1940, 35: 529.—Hess, H. E. Several interesting cases of traumatic pericarditis. Vet. Bull, Wash, 1937, 31: 298.—Krupski, A, & Hofmann, W. Zur Diagnose und Therapie der exsudativen Pericarditis und Pleuritis traumatica des Rindes. Schweiz. Arch. Tierh, 1933, 75: 240-8.—Lienaux. Remarques a propos de la ponction du pericarde pour pericardite traumatique. Ann. med. vet, Brux, 1908. 58: 311-4.—Mathis. Pericardite traumatique. Bull Soc. sc vet. Lyon, 1901, 4: 195-8.—Nitschke. Seltener Fall von Pericarditis traumatica beim Schwein. Berl. klin. Wschr, 1907, 914. —Pendergast, J. A. Traumatic pericarditis. J. Am. Vet. Ass, 1918, 52: 714.—Perrussel. De la pericardite traumatique; sa coincidence avec la fin de la gestation (8, 9. mois, k terme) ou peu apres la mise-bas (1 mois) son diagnostic hatif. Bull. Soc. sc. vet. Lyon, 1901, 4: 43-50.—Pugh, L. P. The diagnosis, treatment and prevention of traumatic peri- carditis in cattle. Vet. Rec, Lond, 1925, 5: 607-12. The radical operation for traumatic pericarditis in cattle (pericardiotomy) Vet. J, Lond, 1925, 81: 136-43. Also Vet. Med, Chic, 1925, 22: 201-3.—Roberts, G. H. Traumatic pericarditis. Am. Vet. Rev, 1911-12, 40: 345-50.—Weber, E. Die Diagnostik der traumatischen Perikarditis des Rindes. Berl. tierarztl. Wschr, 1925, 41: 337-40— Wiholm, S. [Case of pericarditis, caused by a penetrating foreign bodv (fish- bone)] Nord. med, 1939, 4: 3521-3.—Wilkinson, D. E. The gravitation treatment of traumatic pericarditis in cattle. Vet. J, Lond, 1938, 94: 35. ---- Pericarditis: Treatment. ■ Konig, W. [F.] *Ueber Perikarditis und ihre Behandlung. 86p. 8? Bonn, 1930. Bloedorn, W. A. The recognition and treatment of the various forms of pericarditis. Med. Ann. District of Columbia, 1940, 9: 422-5.—Campbell, M. Treatment of pericarditis. Brit. M. J, 1935, 1: 1231-3. Also In Treat. Gen. Pract, 2. ed, Lond, 1938, 1: 207-13.—Churchill, E. D. Surgical aspects of pericarditis. N. England J. M, 1933, 208: 774.—Deicher, H, & Tiedke, H. Fortschritte in der Behandlung der Perikarditis und ihrer I'olgezustande. Fortsch. Ther, 1936, 12: 577-84.— Duguet. Au sujet du traitement chirurgical des pericardites aigues de nature probablement tuberculeuse. Bull. Soc. nat. chir. Par, 1926, 52: 4-7.—Edclman, I. A. [Clinic and treat- ment of pericarditis] Pediatria, Moskva, 1929, 13: 3-14.— Elias, H. Leber die Behandlung der Pericarditis exsudativa und adhaesiva. Wien. klin. Wschr, 1931, 44: 1412. Also Aerztl. Prax, Wien, 1932, 6: 133.—Harrington, S. W. Peri- cardial infection. Surg. Clin. N. America, 1927, 7: 1507-9.— Lemoine, G. Traitement des pericardites. Nord med, 1908, 15: 189-93.—Pinart. Casos pr&cticos; pericarditis. Rev. homeop, Barcel, 1890, 2: 306-12.—Rosenow, G. Behandlung der Perikarditis und ihrer Folgezustande. Fortsch. Ther, 1930, 6: 268-73.—Ruggieri, E. Trattamento chirurgico delle peri- carditi acute e croniche. Policlinico, 1933, 40: sez. prat, 728- 36.—Shaposhnikov, B. [Pericarditis and punctures of the pericardium] Khirurgia, Moskva, 1912, 32: 313-27.—Syllaba, L. [Method of preventing venous thrombosis in pericarditis] Polska gaz. lek, 1927, 6: 884-6.—Westermann, H. H. Die Indikation zur Operation der Herzbeutelentzundung. Klin. Wschr, 1939, 18: 1237-40.—Zerman, C. Osservazioni sopra alcuni casi di pericardite; fenomeni soggetivi; crioterapia. Gior. clin. med, 1930, 11: 790-804. Pericarditis, uremic. Baldauf, L. K., & Ingersoll, R. E. Lremia and pericarditis; findings as they relate to hypertension. Am. J. Path, 1941, 17: 615-7.—Ir»ga. S. Sulla pericardite uremica. Arch. ital. anat! pat, 1934, 5: 987-95.—Olivieri, F. Contributo anatomo- chnico alio studio delle pericarditi uremiche. Policlinico 1936 43: sez. med 411-20.—Richter, A. B. Pericarditis in uremia! J. Indiana M. Ass, 1936, 29: 369-73.—Spangenberg, J. J, & Rossi Belgrano, C. Pericarditis brightica; algunas considera- ciones sobre frecuencia y patogenia. Prensa med. argent, 1935, 22: 1139-47. ---- Pericarditis—in animals. Gadais, M. M. *Des pericardites exsudatives par corps etrangers a evolution atypique [Ecole d'Alfort] 44p. 8? Par., 1927. Semelagne, J. A. *De la pericardite par corps etranger et de son diagnostic precoce [Ecole d'Alfort] 47p. 8? Par., 1927. Benjamin, H. Hydropericardite, avec adenopathie thoraci- que, observe chez un chien. Bull. Soc. centr. med. vet. Par, 1877, 31: 196-9.—Bergeon. Pericardite aigue chez le cheval. J. med. vet. zootech, Lyon, 1907, 5. ser, 11: 327-33.—Jowett, W. Epizootic pneumo-pericarditis in the turkev. J. Comp. Path, Lond, 1908, 21: 324-30.—Larroque. Ln cas curieux de pericardite compliquee mortelle, chez une genisse. Rec. med. vet. Par, 1916, 92: 552-5.—Roetti, C. Studio di un focolaio importato di idropericardite infettiva dei ruminanti. Boll. Ist. sieroter. milan, 1940, 19: 110-4, pl—Semelagne, J. Peri- cardite exsudative sans oedemes chez une vache. Rec. med. vet, 1923, 99: 84-8.—Toman, R. V. [Non-traumatic peri- carditis in cattle] Tschr. diergeneesk, 1934, 61: 237-9. ---- Physiology. Bijlsma, U. G. [On the significance of the pericardium] Geneesk. tschr. Ned. Indie, 1940, 80: 1908-11. ------& Le Heux, J. W. Die Bedeutung des Perikards fur die Dynamik des Saugetierherzens. Arch. exp. Path, Lpz, 1931, 159: 12-40. Die Bedeutung des Pericards fiir Physiologie, Patholo- gie und Pharmakologie des Kreislaufs. Sunti Congr. internaz. fisiol, 1932, 14. Congr, 33-4— Davydov, I, & Kroll, N. G. De la physiologie du liquide du pericarde; le Vagusstoff penetre-t-il dans le liquide du pericarde? Bull. biol. med. LRSS, 1939, 7: 292-4. Also Biull eksp. biol. med, 1939, 7: 307-9.—Ferrari, R. Sulla funzione clinica del cavo pericardico (osservazioni anatomo-patologiche e sperimentali) Boll Soc. med. chir, Pavia, 1929, n. ser, 4: 499-508.—Fineberg, M. H. Functional capacity of the normal pericardium. Am. Heart J, 1936, 11, 6: 748-51— Gibbon, J. H, jr, & Churchill, E. D. The mechanical influence of the pericardium upon cardiac function. J. Clin. Invest, 1931, 10: 405-22.—Hauffe, G. Die Bedeutung des Herzbeutels fiir den Blutumlauf. Munch, med. Wschr, 1926, 73: 1702; 1749; 1801. ------ Der Herzbeutel, ein notwendiger Bestandteil der tatigen Herzmaschine. Fortsch. Med, 1927, 45: 408.—Kamensky, E. A. [Sustaining function of the peri- cardium] Ter. arkh, 1937, 15: 229-33.—Kuno, Y. The significance of the pericardium. Ind. M. Gaz, 1920, 55: 336.—Nelemans, F. A. Die Funktion des Perikards. Arch. neerl physiol, 1939-40, 24: 337-90. Also Acta brevia neerl, 1940, 10: 3-6.—Pfubl, W. Die mechanischen Aufgaben des Herzbeutels und seine Rolle bei der Wechselwirkung von intra- thorakaler Saugkraft und Herzkraft. Anat. Anz, 1929, 67: 337-53—Rossler, R, & Lnna, K. Die Bedeutung des Peri- kards fur das geschadigte Herz. Arch. exp. Path, Berl, 1934- 35, 177: 288-312. ------ Steuerung der Herzleistung durch das Perikard bei wcchselndem Aortendruck. Ibid, 1935-36, 180: 568-77.—Starling, E. [The significance of the pericardium] In Omeliansky & Orbeli Sbornik Pavlova, Leningr, 1924, 69- 73.—Tamarin, I. L. [Barrier function of the pericardium] Probl tuberk, Moskva, 1940, No. 11, 62.—Van Liere, E. J, & Crisler, G. The influence of the pericardium on acute cardiac dilatation produced by vagal stimulation. Am. J. Physiol, 1930, 94: 162-4.—Wilson, J. A, & Meek, W. J. The effect of the pericardium on cardiac distention as determined by the X- ray. Ibid, 1927, 82: 34-46.—Winiwarter, F. Leber die Funktion des Pericards am Froschherzen. Arch. exp. Path, Lpz, 1937, 187: 170-7. ---- Pneumopericardium. Adcock, J. D, Lyons, R. H, & Barnwell, J. B. The circula- tory effects produced in a patient with pneumopericardium by artificially varying the intrapericardial pressure. Am. Heart J, 1940, 19: 283-91. Also repr.—Berner, O. Ein Fall von Pneumopericardium. Virchows Arch, 1937, 299: 750-3.— Beverly, S. S. Pneumopericardium. Med. Bull. Veterans Admin, 1939-40, 16: 172-5.—Buzni, N. A. [Case of pneumo- pericardium in bilateral spontaneous pneumothorax due to different causes] Russ. klin, 1930, 13: 404-9.—Chateau, Tierny & Desbie7. Pneumopericarde k soupape paraissant en rapport avec une ancienne blessure de guerre. Presse med, 1934, 42: 1135.—Chimus & Popesco, A. Sur un cas de pneumo- pericarde spontane. J. radiol. electr, 1932, 16: 605-7.— Doane, J. C, & Jacobs, M. S. Pneumohemopericardium; HEART SAC 3S4 HEART SAC rheumatic and luetic heart disease. Med. Clin. N. America, 1933. 17: 679-92.- Gilbert, A. A. Spontaneous pneumo- pericardium; with report of a case. J. Arkansas M. Soc, 1938 39, 35: 53-6.- Gondos. B. [Pneumopericardium] Orv. hetil, 193S. 82: 735 7.- Gottesman, J, & Ber.dick. A. J. Pneumo- pericardium from radium necrosis. Am. .1. M. Sc, 1926, 171: 715-9, pl.—Lemoine, J. M, & Rossier, J. liieumopericarde suffocant chez un tuberculeux pulmonaire. Rev. tuberc, Par, 1934, I. ser, 2: 1064-6. levy, J, & Cator, R. Les puiumo- peYirardo. simples et complexes. J. med. Bordeaux, 1955, 112: 373-86.— Lets, I). A peculiar case of pneumopyopci icanlium Lancet, Lond, 1926, 2: 1004.—Lucherini, T. Pneuinopeti- lardio aitificiale: contributo clinico e studio delle vanazioru del volume totale del cuore. Cuore & circol, 1926, 10: 3-20.— Molnar, J. Leber Luftansammluiig im Herzbeutel Fortsch. Kontgetistrahl, 1927, 26: 656-8.—Ricaurte Medina, E. Ln ca-o de piicunio-pericardio. Rev. Fac. med, Bogota, 1939- 40, 8: 293-9. —Rigler, L. G. Pneumopericardium. J. Am. M. Ass, 1925, 84: 504-6.—Rosier, O. A. Das Fneuniopyoperi- kardium. 1 ortsehr. Rontgenstrahl, 1918, 25: 442-6.— S, F. I), A: D, C. A case of simple fracture of ribs causing a pneuinola'iiiopei icardiuin. Guy's Hosp. Gaz, Lond, 191(1, 30: 429.- Salmond, R. W. A. Artificial pneumopericardium. Proc. R. Soc. M, Lond, 1922-23, 16: Sect. Electrother, 71-4.— Schutte, J. F, Gonzalez E, & Hernandez Beguerie, R. N'eumo- pericardio puro. Arch. med. int., Habana, 1936, 2: 291-8.— Symon, L, A- Jedlicka, V. [Pneumopericardium with prolapse into tie iraehea] Cas. lek. Cesk, 1940, 79: 141-6, pl—Trimble, H. (L, Eaton, J. L, & Thompson, K. Spontaneous pneumo- pei icanlium in a case of apparently arrested pulmonary mien-ulosi.s. Am. Rev. Tuberc, 1942, 45: 100-2.—Wegemer, E. Das Pneumoperikard als Komplikation im Gefolge der Pneumothoraxbehandhmg. Beitr. Klin. Tuberk, 1938-39, 92: 437-41.—Zecha, P. S. [A case of pneumopericardium] Ned. tschr. geneesk, 1923, 67: pt 2, 1517. ---- Radiography. Brauer, L, & Lorey, A. Die Rontgenuntersuchung des Perikards. In Lehmanns med. Ati, Miinch, 5. Aufl, Bd 7, 1934-38, 5X0-92— Castex, M. R. Le lipiodol dans l'examen radiologique du pericarde. Bull. Acad. med. Belgique, 1926, 5. ser, 6: 44-9, 3 pl.------Carelli. H, & Gonzalez, H. Le lipiodol dans l'exploration radiologique du pericarde. Bull. Soc. med. hop. Paris, 1926, 3. ser, 50: 217-22.—Juzbasic, D. M, & Berner, F. Die Tomographic als Hilfsmittel fur die Chirurgie des Herzbeutels. Zbl. Chir, 1939, 66: 1227-33 — Kautz, F. G, A: Pinner, M. Extrapericardial fat bodies. Am. J. Roentg, 1936, 35: 40 3. ---- Rupture. Peter, H. *Ueber isolierte traumatische Herzbeutelruptur und die Frage ihrer Hcilung. 25p. 8? Kerb, 1936. Crynes, S. F, & Hunter, W. C. Traumatic rupture of the pericardium; study of 22 cases, with 2\'i year period of survival in 1 case; review of literature. Arch. Int. M„ 1939, 64: 719- 46. —Hunter, W. C, & Crynes, S. F. Traumatic rupture of tin' pericardium. Mod. Concepts Card. Dis, 1940, 9: No. 2, 1.—Muller, M. Ln cas de dechirure spontanee du pericarde. Ann. med. leg, 1926, 6: 522-6.—Peter, H. Leber traumatische Herzbeutelruptur. Deut. Zschr. Chir, 1938, 250: 295-309.— Spillmann, P, & Parisot, J. Ectopie du coeur dans la plevre par suite de rupture du pericarde. J. med. fr, 1908, 2: 483- 93, pl.—Wilson, A. C. Rupture of the pericardium in the horse due to fright. Vet. Rec, Lond, 1925, 5: 173. ---- Sarcoma. Bodon, G. [Primary sarcoma of the pericardium] Orv. hetil, 1930, 74: 704-6. Also Frankf. Zschr. Path, 1930, 40: 431-5.—Bowman, P. G. Primary sarcoma of the pericardium; report of a case. Ann. Int. M, 1938-39, 12: 258-66.—Chajutin, D. M. Zur Frage der Sarkome des Perikards. Zschr. Krebs- forsch, 1927-28, 26: 72-9.—Hill, H. Primary round cell saicoiua of pericardium. Arch. Path, Chic, 1928, 5: 626-9.— Khautin, D. M. [Case.- of sarcoma of the pericardium] Odess. med. .1, 1927, 2: 241-5.—Loos, H. Zur Kenntnis der Herz- l.eutel-rschwulste. Z.-clir. Kreislaufforsch, 1929, 21: 193- 206. -Parker, R. L, Baggenstoss, A. H, 'e sc med. Lisbon, 1912. 76: 40-6.—Nicolas. Parencentese du pi'ricaide. Bull. Soc. med. mil fr, 1910, 4: 219.—Roberts, J. B. Two cases of paracentesis of the pericardium. Am. J. M. Sc, 1904, 128: 473-7. Also repr.—Voinich-Syanozhentski, A P [Preparati perikardiotomii] Protok. Russl. chir. Obsh. Pirogova, 1897-88, 1900, 16: 91-4.—Zamfir, C. Sur la para- centese du pericarde. Rev. med. fr, 1938. 19: 37-42. ---- Surgery: Precordial thoracectomy [Brauer] Bascotjl, R. *Les traitements chirurgicaux des symphyses du pericarde; l'operation de Brauer. 73p. 8? Montpel., 1911. Ensghabbr, B. *Ein weiterer Fall von Cardiolyse. 29p. 8? Tiib., 1907. Giguet, L. *De la thoracectomie precardiaque dans le traitement de la mediastino-pericardite de la symphyse du pericarde et de certaines affec- tions du cceur. 83p. 8? Lyon, 1913. Htjrtzig, P. F. *Die chronisch adhaesive Mediastinopericarditis und ihre Behandlung durch Cardiolyse. 26p. 8? Rost,, 1928. Kirchhubel, K. [O.] *Ueber sechs Falle von Cardiolysis [Marburg] 42p. 8? Hamb., 1912. Mercier, A. R. E. *Traitement chirurgical des symphyses pericardiques (operation de Brauer) 91p. 8? Lille, 1913. Merz, H. *Ein Fall von Cardiolyse bei Mcdiastino-Pericarditis. 49p. 8? Erlangen, 1909. . . Schwarzexatjer, R. *Pericardio-mediasti- nale Verwachsungen und Cardiolysis. 26p. 8? Halle. 1907. Basset, A. A propos d'un cas de symphyse cardiaque, traitee par la thoracectomie precoidiale, operation de Brauer; tesultat au bout de 2Vi ans. Mem. Acad, chir. Par, 1938. 64: 384-92—Bergeret, A, & Theodoresco, B. Ln cas d ad- herences pericardiques ameliote par la tesection du gril costal dans la tegion ptecordiale. Bull. Soc. nat. chir. Par, 1926, 52: 7-17.—Bewley, H. T. A clinical lecture on cardiolysis. Brit. M. J, 1910, 1: 914.—Bigger, I. A. Concretio cordis; cardiol- vsis for concretio cordis. Arch. Surg, 1932, 24: 574-80.— B0ggild, D. [Case of mediastinopericarditis, treated by peri- cardiolysis] Hospitalstidende, 1937, 80: [Jydsk med. selsk. forh.] 4-11.—Cambon-Rouslacroix & Plasse. Grossesse et accouchement sans incident 7Yi ans apres une thoracectomie ptecordiale pour svmphvse cardiaque. Bull. Soc. obst. gyn. Paris, 1936, 25: 745-7— Clerc, A, Soupault, R, & Deschamps, P. N. Considerations sur l'operation de Brauer (cardiolyse, thoracectomie nrecordiale) et ses indications au cours de la symphyse pericardique. Progr. med. Par, 1931, 1777-81. -----Resultats eioignes d'une thoracectomie ptecordiale pour mediastino-pericardite. P. verb. Congr. fr. chir, 1932, 41: 300.—Degorce, A. Symphyse cardiaque; pericardotomie et cardiolyse; courte amelioration; mort par asystolie 51 jours apres l'operation. Bull. Soc. med. chir. Indo-Chine, 1913, 4: 24-9.—Delageniere, H. De la pericardiolyse dars certaines affections cardiaques ou de la thoracectomie prepericardique. J. med. int., Par, 1913, 17: 161-6. Also Rev. ther. med. chir, 1913, 80: 405; 433.—Delbet, P, & Hirtz, E. Resultat eloigne d'une cardiolyse pour symphyse cardiaque. Ibid, 1911, 78: 289.—Delorme. E. Symphyse cardiaque et cardiolyse. Rapp. Congr. fr. med. (1925) 1926, 18. sess, 2: 190—Divis, J. [Opera- tive treatment of chronic, adhesive pericarditis with reference to Brauer's cardiolysis] Cas. lek. desk. 1936, 75: 1364; 1399, 2 pl—Donovan, R. E. Sinfisis pericardica; operacion deBrauer- Koemng. Bol. Soc. cir. B. Aires, 1931, 15: 765-70 —Dowd C. N. Cardiolysis. Tr. N. York Surg. Soc, 1913, 2: 296.— Downie, E. Adherent pericardium treated bv cardiolysis Austral N. Zealand J. Surg, 1931, 1: 213-7.—Dunant, R. &, Turrettini, G. A propos d'un cas de symphyse cardiaque oporee (thoracolyse ptecardiaque) Schweiz. med. Wschr 1923. 53: 606.—Fischer, H. Die Bedeutun? der Cardiolyse fur die Therapie. Fortsch. Ther, 1930, 6: 557-63.—Gerke, A. A. [Cardiolysis and its clinical application] Russ. klin, 1924, 1: pt 2, 375-83.—Gregoire, R. A propos de la symphyse cardiaque et de Popci-atiou de Brauer. Bull. Soc. nat. chir. Par, 1926, 52: 33-5.—Guillemin, A. A propos de la cardiolvse. Ibid, 331-3.—Hamdi [Observations on cardiolvsis] Askeri sihhiye mecmuasi, 1934, 63: 135.—Jona, G. Sinfisi cardiaca; operazione di Brauer. Policlinico, 1934, 41: sez. prat, 1597- 1935, 42: sez. prat, 1335.—Kohn, C. M. Cardiolysis: report of a case. In Med. Papers (H. A. Christian Anniv. Vol.) Bost, 1936, 129-33.— Lecene, P. La cardiolisisuoperaci6nde Brauer; su? indicaciones y resultados. Rev. iber. amer. cienc. med, 1910. 23: 131-8.—Lenormant, C. La thoracectomie pte- cordiale dans les cardiopathies autres que la symphyse peri- cardique. Schweiz. med. Wschr, 1935. 65: 33-6.------& Merle D'Aubigne, R. La thoracectomie ptecordiale dans les symphyses et certaines hvpertrophies cardiaques. J. chir. Par, 1928, 31: 161-75.—Leriche, R. Sur un cas de peri- cardiolyse. Bull. Soc. med. hop. Lyon, 1914, 13: 81.------ A propos du traitement de la symphyse du pericarde et de la thoracectomie ptecardiaque. Bull Soc. nat. chir. Par, 1926, 52: 118.—Liebig, F. Erfahrungen mit der Cardiolvse im Kindesalter. Beitr. klin. Chir, 1929-30, 148: 246-54.— Mattison, J. A. Cardiolysis for mediastinopericarditis; with case report. Surg. Gyn. Obst, 1927, 44: 113-5.—Opazo G, F. Algunas consiileraciones a proposito de la cardiolisis. Bol. Soc. cir. Chile, 1927, 5: 126-30.—Piersol, M. H, Griffith. G. C. et. al] The operation of cardiolysis in adhesive pericarditis with Pick's syndrome. Ann. Surg, 1934, 99: 152-66.— Poynton, F. J, & Trotter, W. A case of cardiolvsis. Proc. R. Soc. Lond, 1909-10, 3: Clin, sect, 199.—Rouslacroix. A. Cinq observations de thoracectomie ptecordiale (operation de Brauer) pour symphyse du pericarde, resultats freneraux; deductions cliniques au point de vue du diagnostic. Marseille med, 1929, 66: 124-56, 8 pl.------Zuccoli, G, & Trabuc. F. Mediastino-pericardite calleuse avec crises d'epilepsie cardiaque, traitee par l'operation de Brauer; survie de 23 mois; autopsie. Ibid, 1928, 65: 93-105.—Saloz, C, & Roux-Berber, J. L. Thoracectomie pre-cordiale: operation de Brauer. Mem. Acad. chir. Par, 1938, 64: 392-7—Schall, L, & Orth, O. Zur Perikardiolyse. Med. Klin, Berl, 1931, 30: 436-8.—Schloffer, H. Zur Cardiolyse. Ibid, 1929. 25: 1777-9.—Schmieden, V. The technique of cardiolysis. Surg. Gyn. Obst, 1926, 43: S9-93.—Schoemaker. Resultat eloigne d'une liberation du coeur. P. verb. Congr. fr. chir. 1932, 41: 315-7.—Singer, J. J, & Graham, E. A. Cardiolysis for chronic mediastinal peri- carditis. Arch. Surg, 1929, 19: 1508-70.—Smith, E. S, & Liggett, H S. Cardiolvsis for chronic mediastino-pericarditis. Proc. Interst. Postgrad." M. Ass. N. America (1928) 1929, 489- 502.—Sutherland, G. A. A case of cardiolysis for adherent pericardium. Proc. R. Soc. M, Lond, 1910-11, 4: Sect. Stud. Dis. Child, 41.—Theodoresco, B. C nisi lerations sur l'opera- tion de Brauer. Rev. prat, mal pays chauds, 1927, 7: 398- 400.------& Visineanu, N. Considerations sur l'operation de Brauer k propos de 6 nouveaux cas. Arch. mal. coeur, 1937, 30: 689-99.—Theodorescu. D. [Brauer's operation in adhesive mediastinal pericarditis] Rev. st. med, Bucur, 1928, 17: 109- 26 —Torraca, L. La cardiolisi alia Brauer nella pericardio- mediastiuite adesiva. Arch. ital. chir, 1929, 24: 403-49 — TufTier. A propos de la cardiolyse. Bull. Soc. nat. chir. Par, 1926, 52: 85.—Lmber & Kiinig. Thoraxpraparat der vor 2Vi Jahren wegen schwieliger Mediastinopericarditis und cardiolyse vorgestellten Kranken. Deut. med. Wschr, 1907, 33: 1883.—Worms, R, & Merle d'Aubigne, R. Une observa- tion de thoracectomie pr'cordiale pour symphyse du pericarde. Bull. Soc. pediat. Paris, 1928, 26: 219-25. ---- Syphilis. See Syphilis. ---- Tuberculosis. See Tuberculosis. ---- Tumor. See also subheadings Cancer; Endothelioma; Sarcoma, Hammer, H. Ein Fall von Perilard-Tumor. Rontgen- Draxis 1932 4: 910.— Jellen, J, & Fisher, W. E. Intraperi- cardial teratoma. Am. J. Dis. Child, 1936, 51: 1337-402- Minne, J, & Gernez, L. Volumineuse tumeur congenitale intrape'ricardique; transposition des arteres de la base du cceur. Gyn obst. Par, 1935, 32: 254-63.— Pistoia. G. Ricsrche istologiche su di un tumore rarissimo del Pencardio^propagate alia pleura sinistra. Gior. internaz. sc. med., 1907 29: 100^-20, pl__Tarro, E. Sui tumore epiteliali primitivi del pericardio (contributo casistico) Arch. ital. anat. pat, 1930, 1: 657-64, Pl. 227475—vol. 7, 4th sebies- -23 HEART SOUND 3S(> HEART SOUND HEART sound. See also Heart function. Okias, O., & Braun-Menendez, E. Los ruidos cardiacos en conduiones normales v patologicas. 279p. 23cm. B. Air., 1937. Also English transl. 258p. 22^om. Lond., 1939. Barbeau. J. E. A propos des bruits de la base du cceur. J Hotel-Dieu Montreal, 1939, 8: 22-6.—Boone, B. R„ & Ciocco. A. Cardiometric studies on children; stethograpliic patterns of heart sounds observed in 1,482 children. Milbank Mem. Fund O, 1939, 17: 323-57, pl—Braun Menendez, E, & Orias, O. Estudio fonoeardiogranco en cien adultos iovenes. Rev. argent, card., 1931-35, 1: 101-16.—Garbor, I A, & Zdanovsky, V. U. [Normal melodv of the heart) Klin, med, Moskva, 1937, 15: 73-6.—Gubergritz, A. J, & Falberg, G. F. [Normal melodv of the heart] Ibid.. 908-11.—Houssay, B. A. Les bruits du cceur. Presse med., 1930. 44: 1353-6.—McKee, M. H. Heart sounds in normal children. Am. Heart J, 1938, 16: 79-87.— Murphy, E. The heart sounds. Med. J. Australia, 1939, 2: 457-65.—Patrizi, M. L. Se il trovato del suono muscolare e cardiaco spetti a Guglielmo Harvey o al bolognese Francesco Maria Grimaldi. Boll Soc. ital. biol. sper, 1928, 3: 692-4.— Sacks, H. A, A- Roberts, R. C. Heart sounds in voung adults. Am. Heart .1. 1939. 18: 303 7.—Teliatnikov, S. I. [Melodv of the heart] Kim. med., Moskva, 1932, 10: 805-8.—Trendelen- burg, F. Prinzipielle physikalische und physiologische Fragen bei riiteisuchung und Deutung von Herzschallphanomenen. Verb. Perl med. Ges. i 1^1 1932, 62: T. 2, 307-18.—Wolferth, C. C. Heart sounds. In Cvclop. Med. (Piersol-Bortz) Phila, 1939, 3: 785-99.------& Margolies, A. Heart sounds. In Diagn. Treat. Cardiovasc. Dis. (Stroud, \V. D.) Phila, 1940, 1 :• 507-54. ---- abnormal. See also other subheadings. Braun-Menendc/, E. The heart sounds in normal and pathological conditions. Lancet, Lond, 1938, 2: 761-7.— Ganter, G. Ueber die diagnostische Bedeutung der Knochen- leitung bei Erkranlunnen des Herzens. Munch, med. Wschr., 1930, 77: 1747-9. Horine. K. F. The diagnostic significance of abnormal heart sounds. Kentucky M. J, 1926, 24: 166-71. Also Cincinnati .1. .\i., 1926-27, 7: 346.—Houssay, B. A. Some aspects of the heart sounds under normal and pathological conditions. Proc. California Acad. M, 1935-36, 91-110. Also Brasil med, 1936, 50: 705—Johnston, F. 1>. Extra sounds occurring in cardiac systole. Am. Heart J, 1938, 15: 221-31.—Nelson, G. Heart sounds and their inteipretation. Virginia M. Month, 1926-27, 53: 769 72.—Schindler, E. I. Cardiophonetics: a discussion of the characteristic sound dis- turbances in the common cardiac diseases. J. Osteopathy, 1941, 48: No. 4, 16 -9.—Schwarzmann, J. Die Besonderheiten der Herztone bei infektiosen Krankheiten. • Miinch. med. Wschr, 1924, 71: 1018.—Vogelson, L. I. [Importance of resonance of cardiac sounds in evaluation of function of the myocardium! Ter. arkh, 1932, 10: 116-21.—Wolferth, C. C, & Margolies, A. The various tvpes of extra heart sounds. Med. CUn. N. America. 1930-31, 14: 897-907. ------ Nor- mal and pathological heart sounds. Mod. Concepts Card. Dis , 1936, 5: No. 11, 1. ---- Amplification. See also subheading Recording. Boone, B. R. An amplifier for recording heart sounds tluougl the use of the cathode-rav tube. J. Lab. Clin M 1939-4(1, 25: 188-93.—Devine, J." B. An amplifier for the heart sounds. Clin. Rep. Melbourne Hosp, 1935, 6: 71.— Lafon, G. Sur l'amplification et l'audition collective des bruits du coeur et des autres bruits d'auscultation. C. rend Acad, sc, 1926, 182: 1171-3.—Lemaire, A, & Lefevre, P. Amplification en rcgistrement des bruits du cceur. Prat med. fr, 193 4. 15: 309-14.—Pommerenke, W. T., & Bishop, F. W. Amplification of fetal heart sounds. Am. J. Obst 1938, 35: 851-L —Posener, K, & Trendelenburg, F. Leber Herzgcrausche. Z.-chr. Kreislaufforsch, 1929, 21: 459-70.— Sacks, H. A, ^cm. S. Paulo, 1940. Battro, A, Braun-Menfindez, E, & Orias, O. Le rythme de galop; analyse par la phonocardiographie et la phl^bographie simultanees. J. physiol. path. gin., 1935, 33: 51-63. Also Rev. argent, card, 1934-35, 1: 117-37.—Bendove, R. A, Sarnery, S, & Fierst, S. Gallop rhythm and other triple heart rhythms; a phonocardiographie and clinical study of their mechanism and significance. Med. Times, N. Y, 1941, 69: 431.—Bramwell, C. Gallop rhythm. Brit. M. J, 1935, 2: 739. Also Q. J. Med, Lond, 1935, 4: 149-63, 3 pl—Broustet. Contribution a l'etude clinique du bruit de galop. Arch. mal. cceur, 1934, 27: 754.—Campbell, M, & Suzman, S. S. Simul- taneous disappearance of gallop rhythm and bundle branch block. Lancet, Lond, 1932, 1: 985.—Cipriano Lascalea, M. Ritmo de galope a cuatro tiempos. Rev. san. mil, B. Air, 1940, 39: 337-9.—Conner, L. A. Note on the occurrence of an unusual form of gallop rhythm. Tr. Ass. Am. Physicians, 1927, 42: 66r9. Also Am. Heart J, 1927, 2: 514-7.—Danzer, C. S. The diagnostic significance of gallop rhythm. N. York State J. M, 1936, 36: 10-4.—De Waele. Production experimentale de souffles cardiaques, bruit de galop et arythmies. Bull. 4cad mTd- ?,eJ"1(lue' !.927. 5- ser, 7: 549-77, pl—Dumas, A Le galop d hypotension. J. mid. Lyon, 1928, 9: 543-7.—Fogelson 'JAr • Uer ^alopprhythmus. Zschr. klin. Med, 1931-32 119- rWhli ^r~TT- f TRoTzhk.ova' T- M. [Genesis of gallop rhythm] Med. biol J Leningr, 1927, 3: 29-37.—Freundlich, J. Elektrokardiographische Befunde bei Galopprhythmus Deut Arch khn. Med, 1931, 170: 528-36.-GaIIavardin, L, & Veil, P. Nouveau cas de galop diastolique par trouble de conduction auriculo-ventriculaire. Arch. mal. coeur 1926 19- 797-9— Gil-Casares, M. El galope del coraz6n. Rev. espan" med cir, 1927, 10: 391-407.—Giroux, R. Bruit de galop et hypotension arterielle. Rev. prat. mal. pavs chauds 1927 7- 386-90.—Hamilton, F. C. The significance of gallop rhythm! Canad. M. Ass. J, 1941, 44: 260-4.—Hinohara, S. Systolic gallop rhythm. Am. Heart J, 1941, 22: 720-36—Holt E Galopp rhythm. Ibid, 1926-27, 2: 453-69.—Johnston, f! d! The types of gallop rhythm and their significance. Univ Hosp. Bull, Ann Arb, 1937, 3: 70.—Lascalea. M. C. Ruidos cardlacos fisiologicos y ritmos de galope. Rev. san. mil B Air, 1941, 40: 227; passim.—Laubry, C, & Van Heerswynghels, J. Sur le galop protodiastolique dans l'arythmie complete Bull. Soc. mid. hop. Paris, 1935, 3. ser, 51: 1289-91.—Levick, C. B. Gallop rhythm: its clinical significance in certain cases. Lancet, Lond, 1931, 2: 633-5.—Lian, C. Le bruit de galop gauche. Sem. hop. Paris, 1931, 7: 193; 243. ------& Facquet, J. Le bruit de galop et la mesure de la vitesse de circulation du sang. Cas. lik. cesk, 1937, 76: 725-7. ------ Bruit de galop et d£doublement du premier bruit. Hopital, 1939, 27: 145-7.—Lian, C, & Welti, J. J. Le dSdoublement du premier bruit, et le bruit de galop ptesvstolique retard^. Arch, mal coeur, 1938, 31: [Discussion] 275.—Mozer, J. J, & Duchosal, P. Etude 61ectro-phonocardiographique du rythme du galop. Ibid, 1930, 23: 65-73.—O'Farrell, P. T. What is galopp rhythm? Irish J. M. Sc, 1939, 6. ser. No. 166, 729-39 — Parisi, J. M. Ritmo de galope. Rev. mid. quir. pat. fern B Air, 1939, 13: 94-102.—Pieri, J. Le bruit de galop. Prat. mid. fr, 1926, 5: (B) 251-67.—Potain, P. C. E. The theory of gallop rhythm. In Cardiac Classics (Willius, F. A.) S. Louis, 1941, 652.—Roch, M. Le bruit de galop; quelques mots k propos de travaux tecents. Rev. mid. Suisse rom, 1936, 56: 41-7.—Routier, D, & Van Bogaert, A. Contribution a l'6tude clinique du bruit du galop; le drMoublement ptesystolique tactile du premier bruit. Arch. mal. cceur, 1934, 27: 541-50. Also Zschr. Kreislaufforsch, 1934, 2fi: 604-20.------Con- tribution a l'etude clinique du bruit de galop; renseignements fournis par la cardiographie apexienne associrje a l'^lectro- cardiographie. Arch. mal. cceur, 1934, 27: 389-408.—Routier, D, & Van Heerswynghels, J. A propos du bruit de galop; £tude phonocardiographique. Ibid, 1935, 28: 629-40.— Thompson, W. P, & Levine, S. A. Systolic gallop rhythm: a clinical study. N. England J. M, 1935, 213: 1021-5, ch. ------Diastolic gallop rhythm; a note on certain factors influencing prognosis. Am. Heart J, 1936, 11: 129-34.— Torres, A. Semiologia clinica dos rythmos de galope. Rev. med. mil, Rio, 1936, 25: 132-40.—Vega, M. N. Ritmo de galope. Rev. meU Rosario, 1927, 17: 157-63.—White, P. D. The clinical significance of gallop rhythm. Arch. Int. M, 1928, 41: 1-9. Also repr.—Wolferth, C. C, & Margolies, A. Gallop rhythm. Internat. Clin, Phila, 1933, 43. ser, 1: 16-30, 3 pl------Systolic gallop rhythm; studies on its charac- teristics and mechanism. Am. Heart J, 1940, 19: 129-40. ---- Intensity. Bekeneva, V. A. [Genesis of dull and unclear tones of the heart] Vrach. delo, 1931, 14: 421-5.—Osawa, K. Quantitative investigation of the intensity of heart tones in normal and pathological states. Gun idan zasshi, 1932, No. 231, 2.— Sato, A, & Moriwaki, Y. Difference of intensity of heart sounds expressed numerically; preliminary report. Tohoku J. Exp. M, 1940, 38: 53. ------& Minagawa, T. Quantitative estimation of normal heart sounds in healthy children; pre- liminary report. Ibid, 55-7. ---- Murmur. Cornwall, E. E. Concerning endocardial murmurs. Med. Times, N. Y, 1930, 58: 131.—Doxiades, L. Herzgerausche im Kindesalter. Zschr. Kinderh, 1927, 43: 245-54.—Flint, A. On cardiac murmurs. Med. Classics, 1939-40, 4: 864-900. Also in Cardiac Classics (Willius, F. A.; S. Louis, 1941, 502- 28.—Gonzalo, G. R. Intensidad de los soplos cardiacos. Siglo med, 1928, 81: 593.—Lyon, R. A, Rauh, L. W, & Stirling, J. W. Heart murmurs in newborn infants. J. Pediat, S. Louis, 1940, 16: 310-7.—Maria/i, A. [Heart murmurs] Lek. wojsk, 1936, 27: 257-73.—Perry, C. B. Cardiac murmurs in child- hood. Practitioner, Lond, 1939, 142: 382-94. Also in Mod. Diagn. (Rolleston, H. D, & Moncrieff, A. A.) Lond, 1940, 105-16.—Posener, K, & Trendelenburg, F. Ueber Herz- gerausche. Verh. Deut. Ges. Kreislaufforsch, 1929, pt 2, 91-105.—Raisbeck, M. J. Cardiac murmurs. In Fifth Ave. Hosp. Clin, N. Y, 1927, 29-36.—Rauh, L. W. Cardiac mur- murs in children. Ohio M. J, 1940, 36: 973.—Slesinger, H. A. Heart murmurs. Hygeia, Chic, 1938, 16: 206; passim.— Stine, D. G. Heart murmurs. Clin. Med, 1941, 48: 303-5 — Willius, F. A. Cardiac clinics; a talk on cardiac murmurs. Proc. Mayo Clin, 1934, 9: 795.—Winkler, A. Ueber Eiiteilung, Definition und Nomenklatur der Nebengerausche. Schweiz. med. Wschr, 1929, 59: 744-7. HEART SOUND 3SS HEART SOl'ND ----Murmur, apical. Finebcru, M. H, & Steuer. L. G. Apical systolic murmurs in childicn; follow-up observation- in 100 cases. Am. Heart J, 1932, 7: 553 9.- Johann, A. E. Apica! cardial- murmurs. Abstr. Proc. A--, life Iu-ur. M. Du. Anmin .1926-27) 1928, 11: 155-S2. —Sleuer. I, G, & Fiiubcrg. M. H. Further olsei vat ion- on apical -\ -tolic murmurs in children. Am. Heart J.. 1938, 16: 351-3.- While, P. D. The clinical sisinificance of apical heart muiniurs. Am. J. M. Sc, 1927, 174: 731-8 — Wyckoff, J, & Uunim. J. Observations on an apical diastolic murmur unassoeiated with valvular disease, heard in cases of right ventricular hvpertrophv. Tr. Ass. Am. Physicians, 1935, 50: 280-8. ---- Murmur, audible. ('hex, Y. T. *Ueber Distanzgerausche des Herzen*. Dip. 8? Hamb., 1933. Davydov, M. S. [Cardiac murmurs heard at a . N. England .1. M, 1934, 211: 1007 — London, J. I. I Dil'feiential diagnosis of diastolic murmur] Vrach. gaz.. 1930, 34: 18. --Milliner, M. M. An adrenalin chloiiil test for murmurs in children. Arch. Pediat, N. Y, 1932.49:305-13. ------& Okin, I. The significance of and a differential diagnostic test of precordial murmurs in children. J. Pediat, S. Louis, 1937, 10: 77-89.—Smith, A. L. Confusion in differentiation of heart murmurs and sounds. J. Kansas M. Sue, 1941, 42: -457-62. ---- Murmur, functional [accidental; hemic] Behmoiras,.L. *Etude de la tension arterielle et de la frequence du pouls chez les malades presentant des souffles inorganiques [Geneve] 32p. 8? Andrinople, 1924. Becher. E. Ueber accidentelle diastolische Herzgerausche. Verb. Deut. Ges. Kreishmlforsch, 1934, 7: 296-8.—Bystritsky, J. L. | Functional heart murmurs] Sovet. vrach. J, 1936, 1: 258-fi5.—Cohen. A. J. (Functional diastolic heart murmurs Geneesk. t-chr. Ned. Indie. 1928, 68: 732-9, 2pl—Coronedi, G. Humeri funzionali ortginati da veleni cardiaci. Sperimentale, 1932, 86: 51-73.—Epstein, J. Myatonic cardiac murmurs. Arch. Pediat, N. Y, 1931, 48: 635-9.—Frisch, A. V. Zur Pathogenese akzideuteller Herzgerausche. Med. Klin Berl 1933, 29: 1274-6.—Gupta, P. C. A study of cardiac sounds and murmurs m severe anaemia. Ind. M. Gaz, 1941, 76: 392-6, 2 pl.—Hecko. I. [Accidental heart murmurs in infants] Cas! lek. cesk., 1935, 74: 025-7.—Katsilabros, L. Contribution k la pathogenie de- soothe- fonctionnels. Presse mid., 1928, 36: 1189-91. —----& Blunenfeldt, E. Ueber die anorganischen Herzgerausche; ihre Diagnose durch Pilokarpininiektion Med. Welt, 1932, 6: 1304—Keller, F. Leber die Haufigkeit des akzidentellen l'ulrnoitalisgeiausches im Alter von 18-91 Jahren (Lntersuchungen an Stelluugsi flichtigen und Rekruten) Schweiz. med. A\schr„ 1937. 67: 267.—Kushelevsky, B. P. ISystolic murmur as a phy-iological ] lenomenon in youths of recruiting age) Sovet. med, 1941. 5: No. 8, 13-8- Loewen- beri!. S. A. Functional or nonorganic lean inumnirs Med Tun. - N. Y„ P..28, 56: 102-4.- Maccra. J. M, a Ruchelll A- 1 ■ 1 "S -onlos accident des ,.,, |a infancia. Sem. mid H. An, 1940 47: 1543. -Martini, P. Die akzidentellen Herz- erausche. Khn. Wschr, 1926, 5: 921-5.—Morquio, L Soplos extracardiacos en el nino. Med. nifios, 1922, 23: 225- 265; 289.- Ocriim. H. P. T. Remarques sur les bruits de souffles acci.lentel- de In reVioii cardiiuiue. Acta med. scand, 1936, Suppl. 16. 515-20. - Okin, I. Non-pathologic or func- tional heart murmurs in children. J. M. Soc. N. Jersey, 1931, 28: 100-3—Savitzty. N. N. [Origin of functional "sytolic murmurs of the heart] Klin, med., .Moskva, 1927, 5: 177 87. Also Zschr. Kreislaufforsch , 1929, 21: 6-20.—Siemsen, W. J, Functional hfait muiniui- in newborn infants. Illinois M. .1, 19:!S, 73: 157- 9. Tempski. E. Sopros cardiacos na puberdadc. Rev. med. Parana. 19 10. 9: 17-29.—Tregoubov. A. A. [Dis- cernment of functional sounds of the heart | Klin, med Moskva, 1927, 5: 18-26.— Van Bogaert, A, & Mace. J. I)c- teglement neurovegetatif et souffles de la base du cu-ur. Ann med. Par, 1929, 26: 451-03. Yoshioka. J. The accidental murmur occurring after the hodilv e\eici-e in (he normal heart Acta Srholfe med. lniv. Kioto, 1931 32, 14:328-31. ---- Murmur, merosystolic. (Iartenlaub, H. *Les claqucmonts pi'ri- cardiques. 72p. 8? Par., 1933. Bosco, G. El mecanismo productor del soplo merosistolico. Actas Congr. nac. med, Rosario, 1931. 5: pt 4, 607-12.— Caste, M. R. Sobre soplos mei o-sist.61icos. Prensa mid. argent.. 1931-32, 18: 781-8. Also Arch. mal. coeur, 1933, 26: 444-57.- Pumas, A, Brunat & Vernaud. I e souffle en ^charpe des sujets ag<5s. Lyon med, 1927, 140: 23.—Lian, C. Les claquements pericardiques. In Quest, clin. actual. Par, 1935, 5. ser, 147-60.------& Deparis. Le clnqueinent meso- svstolique pleuropericardique. Bull. Soc. med. hop. Paris, 1933, 3. ser, 49: 496-503.—Lian, C, & Facquet, G. Claque- ments pericardiques (le claquement m^sosystolique pleuro- pericardique; Union mlop .<*« Herztone (Ergebnisse der Herz.sclmllschreibung) Erg. Physiol, 1933, 35: 632-711.—Stephens, G. A. Note on the causation ot heart sounds. Lancet, Lond, 1927, 2: 226. HEART SOUND 390 HEART SOUND ---- Recording. See also Stethoscope. Pazzaxese, D. A fonocardiografia. 160p. 23cm. |S. Paulo, 1940] Arenberg. H. Phonocardiographv and its clinical correlation. Hosp. New-, Wash, 1941, 8: No. 19, 10-9. Also Ann. Int. M, 1940-11. It: 1607-16.—Arrighi, F. P. Un nuevo tipo de membrana para fonocardiografia directa. Rev. argent, card., 1940 41. 7: 82-8.—Ash, J. E. Phonographic records of heart sounds. .I.Am. M. Ass, lull. 117: 2190.—Bass. F. Ueber die graphische Aufzeichnung von llerztonen und Herzgerauschen. Zschr. ges. exp. Med, 1929, 68: 656-72.—Boyer, N. H, Eck- stein, R. W, & Wiggers, C. J. The characteristics of normal heart sounds recorded bv direct methods. Am. Heart J.. 1940, 19: 257-74.- Braun-Menendez, E., & Orias, O. Etude phonocardiogiaphique chez ](!(> adultes jeunes. ,1. phvsiol. path, gen, 1935. 33: 39-511. ISurh. H. IClinieal registration of heart sounds] Nord. med.. 1939, 2: 1814 20. Caeiro, A, & Orias. O. El fonocaidiogiaina ic istnnlo en los distintos focos de auscultaci6n; sus cardctere« y relaciones con el pulso venoso y el electrocardiograma. Hev. argent, card, 1937-38, 4: 71- 112.—Cavanagh, J. R, & Gwvnn, H. B. The normal clectro- steibogram. Med. Ann. District of Columbia, 1941, 10: 326- 30.- Chavez, L, & Flores, T. In modelo de electrofonendo- scopio para auscultaci6n colectiva. Arch. lat. amer. card, Mex, 1931-32, 2: 205-14.—De Costa, E. J. The photostetho- scope, a device for visibly demonstrating cardiac sounds, espe- cially fetal heart sounds. J. Am. M. Ass, 1938, 111: 2008.— Diliberto, U. Ricerche di elettiofonocanlioginfia. Policlinico. 1935, 42: sez. prat, 597-600.—Dini, S, & Matloli. G. Hegi- strazione grafica dei toni e rumori del cuore. Kiforma med, 1939, 55: 831-4, 7 pl—Duchosal, P. Enregistrement graphique des bruits du coeur; 2 process nouveaux d'enregistrement des bruits du cuur. Rev. mid. Suisse rom, 1928, 48: 959-67, 2 pl. ------ Note sur 1'enregistrement graphique des bruits du cceur; k propos d'un nouveau dispositif d'inscrii tion phono- cardiographique. C. rend. Soc. biol, 1929, 100: 319-21.— Elicabe, ('. A. Sobre un procedimiento fono-electrocardio- grafico. 1'ieii-a mid. argent, 1941, 28: pt 2, 1540-4. Gaus, W. lei ui rlie mechanische Registrierung der Herztone bei friihgebnreiien und ausgetrageneu Siiugliugeii. Zschr. Kindei b., 1931, 51: 409-18-Geckeler, G. D. Phonogiaph records of heart sounds, murmurs and an vthmias. Am. .1 M. Sc. 1911 202: 685-7-Groedel, F. M. Kami die graphi-che Daistelhmg der Herztone die Diagnose fordein.' Veih. Dent, ties inn Med, 1929, 41. Kongr,372-85. Haas, I. Method; of regis- tering graphically the sounds of t he heait. Sc. Coiiiiiiuii Pain Inst. Bad Nauheim, 1936, No. 3, 6-10.—Horine, E. F. An evaluation of electrical heart sound records from a clinical standpoint. Kentucky M. J, 1937, 35: 432 6.—Jacobsohn, L. Rontgentonfilm des menschlichen Herzens. Deut med Wschr 1933, 59: 335. Also Verh. Berl. med. Ges. (1933) 1934, 64] 31-3.—Kayser, G. An appliance for hanging up microphones for registeiing the sounds of the heart. Sc. Commun. Bain. Inst, Had Nauheim. 1936, No. 3, 10-2. ------ .— Smith, A. I, Recording and reproduction of a fetal heart murmur confirmed after birth. Aich. Pediat, N. Y, 1941, 58: 549-54.------A method of recording and reproducing heart sounds. Med. Times, N. Y, 1941, 69: 243-6. - —_ Heart sounds by phonograph. Mod. Hosp, 1941. 57: No. 2, 73.------The clinical value of the cardiophonograph Nebraska M. J, 1941. 26: 245-7. - & Herverl. W. J.' A method for recording and reproducing fetal heart siuniU Am. J. Obst, 1940, 40: 102-10. Trendelenburg, V. llerzton- schrcibung und Herztonverstiii kung. Naturwissenschaften, 1929, 17: 73-81.—Weber, A. Zur diagnostlschen Verwertung der graphischen Herzschallregistrierung. Zschr. Kreislauf- forsch, 1928, 20: 549-54.------The recording of cardiac sounds. Med. Press & Circ. Lond, 1935, 191: 419-22.--- Die praktischo Bedeutung der Aufzeichnung des Herzschalls Aerztl. Fortbild. Had Nauheim, 1938, 14: 161-6.—Wybauw, R. L'inscription graphique des bruits du cuur. Ann. Soc. med Gand, 1933, n. ser, 12: 202-8. Also Rev. beige sc. med, 1934 6: 335-41. ---- Reduplication. Cossio, P, & Braun Menendez, E. Desdoblamiento fisio- Iogico de los ruidos del corazon. Rev. argent, card, 1935 -36, 2: 149-69.—Gallavardin, L. Nouvelle observation avec autopsie d'un pseudo-dddoublement du 2e bruit du coeur simulant le d<;doublement mitral par bruit extra-cardiaque telesvstolique surajoute. Prat. med. fr, 1932, 13: 19-23.— Gorzalez Sabathie, L. Estudio fouocanliogri'ifico del des- iloblamiituto del segundo ruido del corazon. Hev. argent, card, 1938, 5: 25-42. Also in his Tennis ennliol, B. Air, 1939, 2: 53-81.—Guarino, A. Sull'interpretazione della genesi dello sdoppiamento del primo tono cardiaco. Cuore & circol, 1939, 23: 349-53, ch.—Kwaskowski, W. [Doubling of heart sounds in an athlete with heart beats at their maximum] Polska gaz. lek, 1927, 6: 493-5.—Laubry, C, & Puddu. Sur une variiSte de de'douhlement du ler bruit cardiaque. Bull. Soc. mid. hop. Paris, 1935, 3. ser, 51: 1286-9.—Lian, C, & Welti, J. J. Le d£doublcment du premier bruit; le premier bruit ptecession auriculaire el le galop presystolique retards. Arch. mal. coeur, 1938, 31: 408-20.- Van Dooren, F. De l'auscultation du cceur; le dedoubleinent du premier bruit. Ann. Soc. sc. med. natur. Bruxelles, 1929, 198-207. ---- Second sound [diastolic] Bittorf, A, Liebig, H, & Trendelenburg. F. Ueber den klingenden zweiten Aortenton. Zschr. Kreislaufforsch., 1927, 19: 681-92.—Canelli, A. F. L'accentuazione del secondo tono aortico nell'adulto e nei bambino ed in particular mode id lattante. Clin, igiene inf., 1930, 5: 261-7. -Hegglin, It. & Holzmann, M. Abnorme Vorzeitigkeit des 2. Herztones be. verlangerter QT-Distauz im EKG. Klin. Wschr, 1937, 16: 1146.—Hochrein, M. Zur Frage des zweiten Herztones. Deut. Arch. klin. Med., 1927, 155: 104-21. Also Verh. Deuti Ges. inn. Med, 1927, 39. Kongr, 155-7.—Loewenstein, W. Ueber einen neuen Weg zur Auskultation des 2. Aortentones. Med. Klin, Berl, 1926, 22: 849.—Martinez Canas, J. Los ruidos diast61icos. Rev. mod. cubana, 1937, 48: 1-46.— Sachs, H. Ueber die Lautstarke des zweiten Herztones in Rumpfbeugehaltung. Zschr. ges. phys. Ther, 1928, 35: 188- 93.—Sihle, M. Ueber die Ursachen der Akzentuation des diastohschen Herztones. Wien. klin. Wschr, 1926, 39: 237- 9.—Vasilenko, V. K. [Direct auscultation of diastolic phase of the heart] Vrach. delo, 1934, 17: 607-14. ---- Splitting. Gubergritz, M. M. Ueber gespaltene und sogenannte uberzahhge Herztone. Zschr. Kreislaufforsch, 1929, 21: 65- 77.—Nekludov, S. F. [Clinical observations on split heart sounds] Vrach. delo, 1928, 11: 1839-43—Pogany, J. (Split- ting of diastolic heart sounds] Orv. hetil, 1930, 74: 979-81. Also Zschr. khn. Med, 1931, 16: 206-13.—Wolferth, C. C, A Margolies, A. The influence of varying As-Ys intervals on split first heart sounds: its bearing on the cause of split sounds and the mechanism of the first sound. J. Clin. Invest, 1935, 14: 605-18. ---- Third sound. See also subheadings Gallop rhythm; Redu- plication; Splitting. Greissler, S. *Le troisieme bruit du cceur ct le dedoublement physiologique du deuxieme bruit (diagnostic avec les rythmes pathologiques a 3 temps) 70p. 8? Par., 1936. Itapena Alves. V. *Da terceira bulha cardiaca. 152p. 8? S. Paulo, 1930. ,oo?as-,M-N- The third sound of the heart. Calcutta M. J, 1939, 35: 365-8.—Bramwell, C. Gallop rhythm and the physiological third heart sound. Lancet, Lond, 1936, 1: 189- 92.—Clerc, A, Zadoc-Bahn, B, & Tavecchi. A propos du tr°is>eme bruit du cceur. C. rend. Soc. biol, 1934, 116: 1017- 20.—Digne, J. Le troisieme bruit et les bruits multiples du cceur. Marseille mid., 1926, 63: 629-40.—Ferrannini, A. HEART SOUND 391 HEART TUMOR Ritmo cardiaco a tre toni. Riforma med, 1934, 50: 176-9 — Gubergritz M. M. [The third normal sound of the heart] Klin, med, Moskva, 1933, 11: 907-12— Leonhardt, W. Ueber den dritten Herzton und das kindliche Herzschallbild. Zschr. ges. exp. Med, 1932. 84: 470-87.—Lian, C. Le troisieme bruit du cceur. Sem. hop. Paris, 1927, 3: 596-607. Also Bruxelles med, 1928, 8: 736. ------ Les rythmes cardiaques physiologiques k 3 temps (remarques cliniques et phonocardio- graphiques) Bull. Soc. med. hop. Paris, 1934, 50: 32-9 — Melik-Gulnasarian, E. A. [Tonus of the cardiac muscle and the 3rd heart sound] Klin, med, Moskva, 1932, 10: 799-805. Also Zschr. Kreislaufforsch, 1932, 24: 433-45.—Olshinsky, F. M. [Third normal heart sound] Sovet. vrach. gaz, 1934, 38: 418-22.—Radvanyi, G. [Phonocardiographie registration of the third cardiac sound heard in complete A-V block] Orv. hetil, 1936, 80: 1024.—Routier, D, & Van Bogaert, A. Con- tribution k Vitude clinique du bruit du galop; le troisieme bruit physiologique; le galop protodiastolique. Arch. mal. cceur, 1934, 27: 588-600.—Steinberg, L. D. Ueber die normale dreigliedrige Melodie des Herzens bei Kindern. Zschr. Kinderh, Berl, 1925-26, 40: 620-2.—Wikner, E. [The third heart sound; normal and pathological gallop rhythm] Hygiea, Stockh, 1930, 92: 922-39.—Wolferth, C. C, & Margolies, A. Gallop rhythm and the physiological third heart sound; characteristics of the sounds, classification, comparative inci- dence of the various types and differential diagnosis. Am. Heart J, 1933, 8: 441-61. --- Vibration, and thrill. See also Fremitus. Bourne, G. Aortic diastolic thrills; report of a case. Lancet, Lond, 1932, 1: 286-8.—Colvin, L. T, & Steinbach, H. B. The cardiovibrograf; an instrument for the recording of pre- cordial vibrations with simultaneous electrocardiogram. Grace Hosp. Bull, Detr, 1937, 21: 1-15.—Smith, J. R, Edwards, J. C, & Kountz, W. B. The use of the cathode ray for recording heart sounds and vibrations; total caidiac vibra- tions in 100 normal subjects. Am. Heart J, 1941, 21: 228-37. --- Variation. Cossio, P, Lascalea, M, & Fongi, E. G. Alternation of the heart sounds. Arch. Int. M, 1936, 58: 812-24.—De Waele. Etude experimentale des modifications des bruits du coeur. Bru- xelles med, 1934-35, 15: 397.—Fabre, R. Activite musculaire et modifications des bruits du coeur. J. nted. Bordeaux, 1934, 111: 17. ------ Les modifications des bruits du coeur sous l'influence des exercices. C. rend. Congr. internat. mid. iduc. phys. (1934) 1936, 2. Congr, 130-2.—Marques, A. As alte- racoes elementar das bulhas cardiacas. Rev. med. Pernambuco, 1941, 11: 1; passim.—Pereira, J. C. Estudio fonocardio- grafico en cincuenta embrazadas normales. Rev. argent, card, 1935-36, 2: 323-34. HEART tumor. See also Aorta, Tumor; Endocardium, Disease and tumors; Pulmonary artery. Braun, O. *Ein Beitrage zur Kenntnis der Herzbasisgeschwiilste beim Hunde. 36p. 8? Lp ., 1933. Kaplan, S. *Zur Kenntnis der primaren Geschwiilste des Herzens und seiner grossen Gefasse [Basel] 8p. 8? Dresd., 1932. Also Zschr. Kreislaufforsch, 1932, 24: 865-75. Bazilevich, I, & Bobretskaia, V. [Case report of a tumor of the heart] In Recueil Strajesko (Bogomoletz, A.) Kiev, 1935, 1059-66.—Bradley, E. B, & Maxwell, E. S. Primary neo- plasms of the heart; report of an unusual case. J. Am. M. Ass, 1928, 91: 1352-4.—Branch, C. F. Primary neoplasm of heart valve. Am. J. Path, 1931, 7: 157-9, pl—Chaika, E. I. [Primary and metastatic tumors of the heart] J. mid., Kiev, 1937, 7: 1383-91.—Fossel, M. Beitrag zur Kenntnis der primaren Herzgeschwulste. Frankf. Zschr. Path.; 1935-36, 49: 355-61.—Giegler, G. Ein Tumor im rechten Vorhof. Deut. med. Wschr, 1926, 52: 1554.—Helwig, F. C. Tumors of the heart. J. Kansas M. Soc. 1935, 36: 265-72.—Lacamp & Jugeat. Presentation de pifce, tumeur du coeur. Rev. path. comp. Par, 1917, 17: 151.—Leriche, R, & Bauer, R. Tumeurs primitives du cceur. Arch. mal. coeur, 1930, 23: 645-60.— Lisa, J. R, Hirschhorn, L, & Hart, C. A. Tumors of the heart; report of 4 cases and review of literature. Arch. Int. M, 1941, 67: 91-113.—Lymburner, R. M. Tumours of the heart; histopathological and clinical studv. Canad. M. Ass. J, 1934, 30: 368-73.—McDonald, S, jr, & Heather, J. C. Neoplastic invasion of the pulmonary veins and left auricle. J. Path. Bact, Lond, 1939, 48: 533-43, 3 pl—Martin, W. C, Tuohy, E. L, & Will, C. Primary tumor of the heart (entrance of the pulmonary artery) Am. Heart J, 1939, 17: 728-34.—Moss- dorf. Geschwulste im Herzen. Zschr. Veterinark, 1930, 42: 409-14.—Neugebauer, W. Hamartom des Herzens. Zbl allg. Path, 1938, 70: 2-5.—Nowicki, W. Beitrage zur patho- logischen Anatomie der primaren Herzgeschwulste, nebst einigen klinischen Bemerkungen. Virchows Arch, 1926, 259: 502-20.—Pommer, G. Zur Kenntnis der primaren Herz- geschwulste. Zschr. Kreislaufforsch, 1931, 23: 65-76, 4 pl.— Scott, R. W, & Garvin, C. F. Tumors of the heart and peri- cardium. Am. Heart J, 1939, 17: 431-6.—Shelburne, S. A. Primary tumors of the heart, with special reference to certain features which led to a logical and correct diagnosis before death. Ann. Int. M, 1935-36, 9: 340-9.------The diag- nosis of tumors of the heart and pericardium; the description of a syndrome encountered in 3 cases, which led to an ante- mortem diagnosis in 1 case. Texas J. M, 1935-36, 31: 433-6 — Siegel, M. L, & Young, A. M. Electrocardiographic findings in tumors of the hear!, with a report of a case. Am. Heart l. 1933, 8: 682-90. Smith, I). S. Neoplastic involvement of the heart. J. Am. M. Ass, 1937, 109: 1192-4. Also repr — Strouse, S. Benign tumors of the heart, with report of a case observed 43 years. Tr. Ass. Am. Physicians, 1938, 53: 99- 101. Also Arch. Int. M, 1938, 62: 401-12—Uehlinger, E. Die Lymphgefassgeschwulste des Herzens. Beitr. path. Anat, 1927, 78: 434 -40.- Vergnolle, M. J. Tumor del coraz6n. Arch, argent, pediat, 1930, 1: 267-71.—Vukan, J. [Tumor of the heart] Orv. hetil, 1940, 84: 356.—Wainwright, C. W. Intracardiac tumor producing the signs of valvular heart disease. Bull. Johns Hopkins Hosp, 1938, 63: 187-200.— Willius, F. A, & Amberg, S. Two cases of secondary tumor of the heart in children, in one of which the diagnosis was made during life. Med. Clin. N. America, 1930, 13: 1307-16.— Windholz, F. Ueber Thromben und Geschwulste des Herzens. Yirchows Arch, 1929, 273: 331-66.—Wood, H. A primary tumor of the heart. Arch. Path, Chic, 1940, 30: 977.— Yater, W. M. Tumors of the heart and pericardium; pathology, symptomatology and report of 9 cases. Arch. Int. M, 1931, 48: 627-66. ---- Cancer. See also subheadings. Drober, H. *Zur Entstehung von Carcinom- metastasen im Herzen an Hand eines Falles [Munchen] 43p. 22cm. Wurzb., 1938. Duchatel, J. *Contribution a l'etude des cancers du coeur. 44p. 8? Par., 1937. Westhoff, J. B. *Ueber Karzinommetastasen im Herzen. 36p. 8? Berl., 1934. Adams, G. B. Malignancies of the heart; case report. South. M. J, 1927, 20: 933-6—Agrinsky, M. E. [Diagnosis of malignant tumors of the heart] Ter. arkh, 1937, 15: 400-7.— Ahumada, J. C. Metastasis cardiaca. Sem. med, B. Air, 1927, 34: 1366.—Auerbach, O, Epstein, H, & Gold, H. Metastatic carcinoma of the heart; a case presenting auricular flutter, svmptoms of coronary thrombosis, and congestive heart failure. Am. Heart J, 1936, 12: 467-72— Brachetto- Brian, D. Epitelioma metastatico subpericdrdico en napa. Rev. As. mid. argent, 1936, 50: 997-1005.—Burgsdorf, M. V. On metastatic cancer of the heart] Kazan, med. J, 1939, 35: No. 8, 74-7.—Burke, E. M. Metastatic tumors of the heart. Am. J. Cancer. 1934, 20: 33-47.—Cashion, W. A. Metastatic carcinoma of the heart. U. S. Veterans Bur. M. Bull, 1927, 3: 810-4, 2 pl—Fitzwilliams, D. C. L. Carcinoma of the heart. Brit. M. J, 1927, 1: 744.—Gernez, C, Breton, A, & Boury, M. Cancer du coeur secondaire a un Epithelioma de la langue cliniauement gu6ri par l'application de radium. Bull. Ass. fr. cancer, 1937, 26: 58-63.—Grosjean, W. A, & Snyder, C. D. Cardiac metastasis from carcinoma of the thyroid. J. Kansas M. Soc, 1941, 42: 253-5.—Hamilton, R. I, Metastatic carcinoma of the heart. Am. J. Cancer, 1932. 16: 205-9.— Horanyi, M, & Timcsak, A. Mikroskopische Krebsmetastasen des Herzmuskels. Krankf. Zschr. Path, 1935, 48: 297-304 — Hsiung, J. C, Szutu, C. [et all Metastatic tumors of the heart; report of 2 cases diagnosed clinically. Chin. M. J, 1940, 57: 1-10, 5 pl.—Kapsinow, R. Cancer of the heart; secondary to cancer of the breast by direct lymphatic extension. Ann. Surg, 1926, 83: 161-4.—Logefeil, R. C. Metastatic carcinoma of tricuspid valve. Minnesota M, 1933, 16: 539-41.—Miller, J. K. Metastatic tumors of the heart. Am. J. Surg, 1936, 32: 527-9 —Morris, L. M. Metastases to the heart from malignant tumors. Am. Heart J, 1927-28, 3: 219-29.—Nakano, M, & Shirai, S. Ueber die Herzmetastasen der bosartigen Ge- schwiilste. Mitt. med. Akad. Kioto, 1930, 4: H. 5, No. 3, 120.—Nusbaum, W. D, & Heyer, F. W. Carcinoma metastases to heart and subcutaneous tissues. Am. J. Cancer, 1935, 24: 831-8.—Pollia, J. Some notes on malignancies of the heart. Ibid, 1936, 27: 329-33.—Popp, L. Demonstration zur Diffe- rentialdiagnose der bosartigen Herztumoren (mit Projektionen) Fortsch. Roenlgenstrahl, 1937, 56: Tagungsh, Beih. 2, 35 — Reuling, J. R, & Razinsky, L. Metastatic bronchogenic carcinoma of the heart; report of case, with clinical diagnosis by progressive electrocardiographic changes, and pathologic confirmation. Am. Heart J, 1941. 21: 470-80.—Rezek, P. Ueber eine primare epitheliale Geschwulst in der Gegend des Reizleitungssystems beim Menschen (zugleich ein Beitrag zur Histiogenese seltener Herzgeschwulste) Virchows Arch, 1938, 301: 305-20.—Ritchie, G. Metastatic tumors of the myo- cardium; a review of 16 cases. Am. J. Path, 1941, 17: 483-9.— Schmid, B. Ueber eine seltene Form der Herzkarzinose. Zbl. allg. Path, 1936-37, 66: 322-7.—Schnitker, M. A, & Bailey O. T. Metastatic tumor of the heart; a case diagnosed during life. J. Am M. Ass. 1937. 108: 1787-90.—Shelburne, S. A, & Aronson, H. S. Tumors of the heart; report of a HEART TIMOR 392 HEART TUMOR secondary tumor of the heart involving the pericardium and the bundle of His with remission following deep Roentgen-rax therapy. Ann. Int. M, 1940-41, 11: 728 -36.— Simecek, A. Metastatic carcinoma of the heart, secondary to carcinoma of the uterine cervix. Med. Woman J., 1938, 45: 35-7- Ward, E. M. Secondary cair um oi the myocardium. Lancet, Lond, 1934, 2: 250.— Windrmh'. F. Leber massige Geschwulst- metastasen im Herzmu-i < ! Z-chi. Kreislaufforsch, 1930, 22: 1-13. ■---- Cyst. See also Heart muscle, Cyst. Chalet. A. de. Kongenitale Epidermoid-Cv.-te des Herzens, Frankf. Zschr. Path, 1932-33, 44: 426-9. Davidsohn, I. Epithelial cyst of the heart. Arch. Path, Chic, 1938, 26: 422 -8.— Squires, W. H. A cvst in the left ventricle of the heart. Internat. Chn, Phila, 1930, 40. ser, 3: 43-0, pi. ---- Endothelioma. Choisser, R. M, & Ramsey, E. M. Angioreticuloendo- thelioma ' Kaposi's disease) of the heart. Am. J. Path, 1939, L>: 15.5-77, 3 pl------Etiology of Kaposi's disease; pieliminary report of investigations. South. M. J, 1940, 33: 392-6.—Gross, P, & Englehart, C. E. Primary hemangio- endothelioma of the heart; report of a case. Am. ,'T. Cancer, 1937, 30: 102 7. —Hewer, T. F, & Kemp. R. P. Malignant haemangio-oiidotlielioinn of the heart; report of a case. J. Path. Bact, lond., 1936. 43: 511-5, 3 pl—Perry, C. B.. & Rogers, H. I.\ inplinngio-endothelioma of the heart causing complete heart block. Ibid, 1934, 39: 281-4, 2 pl Also repr.— Schlege, M. Ausgebreitetes Rankenangiom beider Kranz- arterien des Herzens und ihrer Verzweiguugen beim Rind. Berl tierarztl. Wschr., 1933, 49: 21—Weller, G. L, jr. The clinical aspects of cardiac involvement, right auricular tumor, in idiopathic hemorrhagic sarcoma, Kaposi's disease. Ann. Int. M, 1940-41, 14: 314-22. ---- Fibroma, and neuroma. Maxoloff, (-. *l*eber einen Fall von Papillom einer Pulmonalklappe. 12p. 8? Heidelb., 1930. Bohrod, M. G. Multiple heniangiofiluonia of the pul- monary valve. Tr. Chicago Path. Soc. 1928-29, 13: 124-33. Also Arch. Path, Chic, 1929, 8: 68-77. Cilotti, M. Sui rosidetti tumon papillari delle valvule cardiache. Pathologica, Genova, 192'.b 21: 613-28.—Hertzoc, A. J. Papillary fibroma of cardiac valve. Arch. Path, Chic, 1936, 22: 222-L— Macherey, W. Kin Fibrom mit Knochenbildung in der Mus- kulatui chs linken Ycntrikels; Beitrag zur Kasuistik primarer llerztumoren. Beitr. path. Anat, 1936 37. 98: 565-70.— Montpellier, M. NeVrome plerifoi trie du m-'ii chez une vache. BuU. Ass. fr. cancer, 1928, 17: 169-71. Petit, G. Note sur un volumineux fibrome infra-cardl>que chez une vache. Rev. path, comp., Par, 1917, 17: 181 Symeonidis, A, & Linzbach, A. J. Ueber die fibro-elast<-en ilannn tien des Myokards (sogenannten Herzfibrome) Virchows Arch, 1938. 302: 3S3-404.— Teuscher, M. Ueber ein Herzfibrom. Frankf Zschr. Path., 1927, 35: 101-6.—Weber, H. Ein Papillom der Pulmonalklappe. Zbl. allg. Path, 1930, 48: 49-54. ---- Leio- and rhabdomyoma. Schliebe [E. K.l H. *Zur Frage der Lebens- fahigkeit bei angeborenen Rhabdomyomen des Herzens. 26p. 8° Lpz., 1932. Uehlixoer, E. *Ueber einen Fall von diffu- sem Rhabdomyom des Herzens [Zurich] p.719- 30. 8? Berl., 1925. Also Virchows Arch, 1925, 258: \Veese, K. [E. M.] *Ein Fall von primarem malignem Leiomyom des Herzens. 20p. 8° Berl., 1931. Baruchev, S. K. [Case of rhabdomyoma of the heart] J. rann detsk. vozr, 1933, 13: 473.—Berger, L, & Vallee, A. Les rhabdomyomes congenitaux du cceur. Ann. anat. path Par, 1930, 7: 797-811.-Brown, G, & Gray, J. A case of congenital ihabdomyoma of the heart. Lancet, Lond, 1930 I: 915.—C laussen, L. Ein fall solitaren Rhabdomyoms des ITeizen- benn Schwein. Deut. tierarztl. Wschr, 1938, 46: 838; M_\- Kliukis, M. Mort subite d'un nouveau-n£ par rhabilomvome du cceur et reins pol\ 1 v-tiques. Ann mid \ig., 1937, 17: 815-8.—Esdobar Pires, R, & Mucciolo, p! Rabdomioma no coracao de um bovmo. Rev. Fac med vet Univ. S. Paulo, 1938-39, 1: 67-78, 5 pl—Farber, S. Congenital rhabdom;, ..im. of the heart. Am. J. Path, 1931, 7: 105-30, 4 pl—Hillman. R. W. Tuberous sclerosis, with congenita! rhabdomyomas of the heart discovered in a child dying of acute lead poisoning. Brooklyn Hosp. J, 1941, 3: 181-95.—Hueper ™- / • Rhabdomyoma!osis of the heart in a Negro. Arch' Path, Chic, 1935, 19: 372-9.------Rhabdomyomatosis of the heart in a guinea pig. Am. J. Path, 1941, 17: 121-4, pl — III, C. H, & Gray, J. W. Congenital rhabdomyoma of the heart Am. J. Obst, 1934, 28: 264-7.—Labate, J. S. Con- genital rhabdomyoma of the heart; report of a case. Am. J. Path.. 1939, 15: 137-50. pl. Larson. C. P, A Lidberk. W. |, Phabdonn osai coma and other mvocardial tumors. West. .1 Surg, 1910. 48: 151 3. Larson. G. P, & Sheppard. J. A. Primal v rhabdomyoma, of the heart with .sarcomatous exten- sions. Arch. Path, Chic, 193S, 26: 717-23. Melnikov- Kazvedenkov, N. P. | Mull inl<- and solitary rhabdomyoma of l he heaii in man (report cases from the Ukraine, Soviet Russia and Europe)| Mosk. med. J, 1929, 9: No. M. 64-6.- Mentl, S. | Problem of the myomatous heart | Cas. lei. cesk, 193l' 73: 741 4. O'Flynn, E, . J. Pediat . S. Louis, 1935, 6: 51-6.- Kilter, S. A., Gross. I.., & Kugel, M. A. Blood vessels in the valves of nor- mal human heaits; from a studv of 700 human hearts. Am. Heart J, 19l'7 2S, 3: 433-46. Wearn, J. T, Bromer. A. W.. A Zschiesche, I, J. The incidence of blood vessels in human heart valves. Ibid, 1936, 11: 22-33.—Wearn, J. I , & Moritz. A. R. The incidence and significance of blood vessels in normal and abnormal heart valves. Ibid, 1937, 13: 7 Hi. Wigand, R. Zur Darstellung der Gefasse normaler Herzklappen durch Injektion. Verh. Deut. Ges. inn. Med, 1930, 12. Kongr, 321-3. ---- Calcification, and sclerosis. Geerlixg, J. G. ^Sclerosis annularis valvu- larum [Groningen] 56p. S? [Leeuwarden] 1929. Also Ned.- tschr. geneesk, 1929, 73: pt 2, 5633. Becker, K. Zur Frage der Endokardfibro.se des jungen Sauglings. Jahrb. Kinderh, 1931-32, 3. F.. 84: 64-71 — Corvisart. J. N. Essay on the diseases and organic lesions of the heart; iransl. bv J. Gates, 1812. In Cardiac Classics (Willius, F. A.) S. Louis, 1941, 282-90, facs.—Dormanns, E. Zur sogenannten linksseitieen Conusstenose. Beitr. path. Anat, 1939, 103: 235-41. Kp-tein, B. S. Comparative study of valvular calcifications in rheumatic and in nonrheumatic heart disease. Arch. Int. M. 1940. 65: 279-90.—Hoffmann, D. Beobachtungen rom geunlogi-ch sichtharer Verkalkungen von Herzklappen. Rontgenpraxis, 1939, 11: 611-5.—Kirch, E. Ueber Grossen- und Massenveranderungen der einzelnen Herzabschnitte bei Herzklappenfehlern, insbesondere bei Mitralstenose und Aortenstenose. Verb. Deut. Ges. inn. Med, 1929, 41. kongr.. 324 30.—Kommerell. B. Verkalkte Herz- klappen nn Rontgenhild. 1 ortsch. Rontgenstrahl, 1936, 53: 34 44.- Moia, B, A: Acevedo, H. J. Diagnostico radiol6gico de las calciricaciones valvularcs. Hev. anient, card, 1939-40, 6: 46-51. Nelson, R. L., et Wells, A. H. Confluent calcifica- tion of aortic and mitral valves. Minnesota M, 1939, 22: 527-9.—Rosenthal, S. R. Quatravalvular stenosis of the heart. In Path. Conf. t.Iaffe, R. H.) Chic, 1940, 586 — Sparks, J. V, & Evans, C. Radiography of calcification in cardiac valves during life. Brit. J. Radiol, 1934, n. ser, 7: 463-6. ---- Disease. See also Endocarditis; Heart disease. Borman. M. C. Disease of the heart valves. West Virginia M. J, 1929, 25: 339-43.—Davis, H. Valvular disease of the heart. Med. Press & Circ, Lond., 1397, 195: 392-5.—Dieu- daide, F. R. The development of our knowledge of valvular disease of the heart. China M. J, 1933, 47: 785-804.—Elias, H. Some features of the valvular diseases as determined by necropsy. Hull. N. York M. Coll, 1941, 4: 15-26.—Galli, G. Os vicios valvularcs organicos do coracao em tempo de paz e de guerra. Has. clin. cient, S. Paulo, 1940, 9: 367-70.— Kimura, Y. Herzklappenfehler und Gestation. Nippon fujinkagakkai zasshi, 1932. 27: Nos. 7-12, 43.—Lewis, M. L. Endocarditis and valvular diseases of the heart in children. J. Oklahoma M. Ass., 1927, 20: 13 5. Liebermeister. Erkran- kungen des Herzmuskels und der Herzklappen. Deut. Aerzte Ztg, 1933, 8: No. 369.— Maresch. R. Ueber Herzklappenfehler. Wien. klin. Wschr.. 1928. 41: 80-3.—Parade, G. W. Herz- klappenfehler und Schwangerschaft. Munch, med. Wschr , 1939, 86: 681-7.—Schnizer, von. Tod bei vorbesteheudem Herzklappenfehler nicht als Folge einer Dienstbeseh.;idigun<* anerkannt. Med. Klin, Berl, 1926, 22: 102.—Stott. A. W. Chronic valvular disease of the heart. Brit. M. J, 1935, 1: Ki83. Also in Tieat. Gen. Pract, 2. ed, Lond, 1938, 1: 187- 93.- Yander Veer. J. B. Chronic valvular heart disease. In Cyclop. Me.l i Piersol-Bortz) Phila, 1939, 3: 732-42. Also in Diagn. Treat. Cardiovasc. Dis'. (Stroud, W. D.) Phila, 1940 1: 362-86. ---- Disease, combined. Almeida Toledo, P. de. Consideracoes sobre o diagnostico das lesoes aortico-mitraes associadas. Rev. med S Paulo 1930-31, 15: 217-29, 2 pl—Barker. L. F. Chronic valvular disease of the heart (double mitral and double tricuspid lesions) of rheumat u- origin, with signs of cardiac failure and with palpable spleen. Med. Clin. N. America, 1930, 14: 215-7__ Beretervide, E. A, Sarmiento, A. I, & Reboiras, J. I. Est're- chez tncuspidea e insuficiencia mitral. Arch, argent pediat 19.39-. 11: 273-80.—Dumas, A, & Brunat. Quadruple lesion orineielle chez une femme de 87 ans morte de pneumonie et nayant jamais ptesente que des signes d'auscultation pas 1 h i ertrophie cardiaque. Lyon med., 1927, 139: 459-61__ F.bas. H , & Goldstein, J. Ueber die Art der Dekompensation ei lombinierten Erkrankungen der Mitral- und Aortenklappen /to \ eigleich mit den Dekompensationszustanden bei Erkran- kungen an einer dieser Klappen. Zschr. klin. Med, 1930 114- 690-701.—Hunter, D. .Mitral stenosis, tricuspid stenosis and incompetence; auricular fibrillation; varix of right external jugular vein. Proc. R. Soc. M, Lond, 1926-27, 20- Sect Chn, 26-9.—Jokl, E, & Suzman, M. M. Aortic regurgitation and mitral stenosis in a marathon runner, with special reference to the effects of valvular heart disease on physical efficiency. J. Am. M. Ass.. 1910, lit:- 407 70. -Ocltinger, I. Zur Diagnose der lombinierten Herzklappenfehler. Miinch. med. Wsehr.. 1931. 78: 1647.- Thompson. W. P., A- Levine, S. A. A comparison of accuracy in the diagnosis of single and multiple valvular disease of the heart. N. Kngland J. M, 1936, 215: 070. White, P. I). A note on the differentiation of the dm stolic murmurs of aortic regurgitation and of mitral stenosis Boston M. & S. J, 1926. 195: 1146. ---- Disease: Diagnosis. Brito, A. X., jr, de. *Elementos de diagnose das lesoes valvularcs do coracao forneeidos polo apparelho circulatorio. 72p. 12? Lish, 1S71. Bassi, G. La studio delle prove funzionali canliachc nei vizi valvolari compensati. Cuore & circol, 1937. 21: 31- 55.—Glogner. Herzklappenfehler und Klcktrokardingraphie Zbl. inn. Med., 1935. 56: 376.—Grosz, I). | Adrenalin test in valvulardisease] Budapesti orv. ujs, 1934,32: 1061. --- Adreiialineiiipfindlichkeit und Herzklappenfehler. Deut. med. Wschr., 1935, 61: 219.—Grundig, J. Krgebnisse der Veuen- pulsschreibung; der physiologische Yenenpuls; die diagnostische Bedeutung des Yenenpnlses l>ei organisclien Herzklappenfehlcrii Zschr. Kreislaufforsch., 19.34. 26:769-82.- Jarobi. J„ Baumann! F, & Rikl, A. Hypertrophic und Dilatation im Elektrokardio- gramm experimenteller Herzklappenfehler. Deut. Arch. klin. Med, 1931, 170: 490-5. Koritzky, A. M. [Determination of the primary source of infection in organic ventricular diseases of the heart] Klin, med, Moskva, 1929, 7: 160-8.—Lossen, H, & Schneyer, K. Das Rontgenbild des Kaninchenherzens in der Norm und bei experimentellen Klappenfehlern. Fortsch. Roeutgenstrnhl., 1935, 52: 132-47.—Maliner, M. M, & Muns, W. E. Electrocardiographic changes in children with chronic caidiac valvular disease following subcutaneous injection of epinephrin. Arch. Pediat, N. Y, 1933, 50: 719 26. Moreno, E. El diagn6stico de las cardiopatias valvularcs cionicas, en la priictica. Gac. med. mil, Mex., 1934 -35, n. ser, 2: 75- Ohm, R. Die Erkennung des Herztonus und seiner Storungen sowie !->(■ 1935 37: 595.—Levine, V. Mitral stenosis. In Path. Conf. (Jaffe, R. H.) Chic, 1940, 706.—Melnick. Mitral HEART VALVE 398 HEART VALVE stenosis. Ibid, 943-5. Mengoli. V. Sulla stenosi mitralica. Riv. clin. pediat, 1937. 35: 540 61.—Monteiro, E. Estenose mitral Gaz. clin, S. Paulo. 1928, 26: 178; 226; 280.- Neiman, B. Mitral stenosis. In Path. Conf. (Jaffe, R. H.l Chic, 1940 1023—Pallasse & Cade. R. Retrecissement mit nil pur chez'l'homme. Lvon med, 1929, 143: 547 9. Paolucci. A. Estrechez mitral. Aceion med, B. Air, 1940, 10: d2( 32.— Richards. W. G. Mitral stenosis. J. Lancet. 1927, 47: 3.x- 511 Roberts, S. R. Mitral stenosis. .Mod. Concepts Card. Dis 1U37 6: No. 11. 1.—Rolleston. H. The history of mitral stenosis Brit. Heait J, 1941, 3: 1-12.—Routier, 1), & Perrin, G. le 'n't recis-e, nent mitral. Bull. med.. Par., 1926, 40: 237-46.- Simoes, (). Estenose mitral Hora med, Rio, 1940 No 26, 15-9- Straehlev. C. J. Mitral stenosis. J. Med', Cincin, 1928-29, 9: 417-21.—Surmont, J. Le tettecisse- ment mitral. Gaz. med. France, 1933, cahier No. 12, 112-6 — Walsh. B. J, Bland, E. F, & Jones, T. D. Pure mitral stenosis in voung persons. Arch. Int. M, 1940, 65: 321-7.—White P. I), & Bland, E. F. Mitral stenosis after 80; with especial reference to Dr Herman V. Vickery. J. Am. M. Ass., 1941, 116: 2001-4. ---- Mitral valve: Stenosis: Complication. Tsacoxa, A. L. *A propos d'un cas de retre- cissement mitral avec absence de la eloison interauriculaire [Geneve] 44p. 8? Par., 1927. Bazan, F, & Maggi, R. Estrechez mitral pura con embolia de la arteria silviana. en un nifio de 10 anos. Arch, argent. pediat, 1937, 8: 1S6 99. Also Prensa med. argent, 1937, 24: 1172-81. Also Sein. med, B. Air.. 1937, 44: 1269-77 — Cesari. A. M. Stenosi mitralica con comunicazione mter- auricolare. Cuore & circol, 1935, 19: 213 26— Chutro, P. Estrechez mitral; endocarditis, niiocanlitis. insuficiencia cardiaca, hiposistolia, trombosis einliolica de la poolitea izquierda, gangrena de pierna y pie; amputacion osteoplastica de rodilla, sin drenaje. In his Lecc. clin. quir, B. Air, 1938, 3- 407-1S — Gallavardin, L. Le retrecissement mitral oede- mateux. .1. med. Lvon, 1934, 14: 609-23.—Galli, G. La neurosi mitralica. Gazz. osp, 1929, 50: 748; 981; 1205.— Gibson, S, & Roos, A. Open foramen ovale associate 1 with mitral stenosis. Am. J. Dis. Child, 1935, 50: 1465-75.— Halipre. Insuffisance ou retrecissement mitral coincidaiit avec une communication interauriculaire et realisant un syndrome de maladie de Holier (souffle svstolique sans cyanone) Bull. Acad, med, Bar, 1929. 3. ser, 101: 478-81.—Harris, A. W, & Levine, S. A. Cerebral embolism in mitral stenosis. Ann. Int. M, 1941-42, 15: 637-43.—Hatieganu, I, & Anca, E. [Case of mitral stenosis, with progressive left auricular throm- bosis] Cluj. med, 1927. 8: 590 3. Jerofejcff, P. Offenes Foramen ovale bei Mitralstenose. frankf. Zschr. Path, 1933, 46: 92-6.—Jervell, A. [Two cases of initial stenosis plus hypothyreosis] Nord. med, 1940, 7: 1594—Jones, R. A case studv; mitral stenosis with auricular fibrillation. Am. J. Nurs, 1938, 38: 1151-6.—Konstam. G. Auricular fibrillation simulating auricular flutter; mitral stenosis. West London M. J, 1933, 38: 31.—Kreutzer, R, A: Diaz Bobillo, I. Con- sideraciones sobre un caso de estrechez mitral con accesos de taquicardia paroxlstica supraventricular. Prensa med. argent, 1937, 24: 1936-42.—Langeron, L, & Loheac, P. Sur un cas de retrecissement mitral avec persistance du trou de Botal; realisation d'une asystolie k type ventriculaire droit. Paris med, 1928, 69: 545-9.—Langeron, L, & Torek, A. Syndrome de Claude Bernard-Homer au cours dun retrecissement mitral. J. sc. med. Lille, 1928, 46: pt 2, 41-5.—Levine, S. A, & Kauvar, A. J. The association of angina pectoris or coronary thrombosis with mitral stenosis. J. Mount Sinai Hosp. N. York, 1941-42, 8- 754-04 —Lutembacher, R. Stenose mitrale et communica- tion interauriculaire. Arch. mal. coeur, 1936, 29: 220-36 — McGinn, S, & White, P. D. Interauricular septal defect associated with mitral stenosis. Am. Heart J, 1933, 9: 1-13.— Margaret, J, & Rimbaud, P.. Dilatation anevrismale con- siderable de l'oreillette gauche consecutive a un tettecissement mitral. Arch. Soc. sc med. biol. Montpellier, 1933, 14: 58- 61. Mitchell, W. G, & Bauer, J. T. Interauricular septal defect associated with mitral stenosis; report of a case. Bull. Ayer Clin. Lab, 1934, 3: No. 13, 29-33, 2 pl—Morgagni, G. B. Letter the third, which concludes the observations on the sanguineous apoplexy [description of mitral stenosis] transl. by B. Alexander. In Cardiac Classics (Willius, I'. A.) S. Louis, 1941, 176-9, fascim.—Nobecourtl Rettecissement mitral pur et syphilis congenitale. Hev. gen. clin. ther, 1929, 43: ii25-31.—Paolucci, A. Estrechez mitral y hemiplejia. Dia med, B. Air, 1931-32. 4: 553.—Potter, E. B. A new case of free ball thrombus n-sociated with mitral stenosis. Ann. Chn. M, 1925-26, 4: 736-47.—Pridie, K. H. A case of mitral stenosis with auricular fibrillation, treated with digitalis bv the Cary Eggleston method. Bristol Med. Chir. J, 1928, 45: 125-8.—Rabuffetti, L. V, & Moia, B. Estrechez mitral \ epilepsia. Dia med, B. Air, 1931-32, 4: 343.—Rosenthal, S. R. MifYal stenosis with ball valve thrombus. In Path. Conf. iJaffe, R. II.) Chic, 1940, 483-5.—Sailer, S. Mitral stenosis with interauricular insufficiency. Am. .1. Bath, 1936, 12: 259-67, 2 pl.—Scherrer & Devallet. Un cas de psychose cardiaque: complication cetebrale dun tettecissement mitral grave. Ann. med. psycho!. Par, 1939, 97: pt 2, 73-9.— Schonberg, H. Ueber Voi hofstlu oinlien bei MitiaUtenoseu. Med. Welt, 1937, 11: 1777-81.—Sciuto, J. A, Alvarez Preve, A., & Castiglionc -Vlonso. H. Trombosis auricular con pi.-b.-iu- nauciu deie.-ha. en el curso de una est rechez mitral \k-Ii. urug. med, 1931. 1: 602-7.- Wcill-Halle, R, & Weill. J. Coexistence de retrecis'ement mitral pur, de lupus et d'un spina ventosa chez un enfant de 10 ans. Bull. Soc. pediat. Baris, 1928, 26: 515 S. Zclusco, A. M, & Mus. S. Trata- miento medico de multiples embolus aitenales en una estre- chez mitral. Sem. med., B. Air, 1941, 48: 7X7 93. ---- Mitral valve: Stenosis, congenital [Duro- ziez] Temersox, H. *La maladie de Duroziez; etude 6tiologique et pathogenique. 151p. 24cm. Par., 1938. Audebert & Dupont, H. La grossesse et l'accouchement dans les tettecissements congenitaux de la valvule mitrale. Ann. gyn. obst. Par, 1908, 2. ser, 5: 399-413.—Castro, A. Sobre 5 casos de apertos mitrais clinicamente puros (iloeuca de Duroziez) Med. contemp, Lisb, 1933, 51: 267; 273. Field, C. E. Congenital mitral stenosis. Arch. Dis. Childh, loud, 1938, 13: 371-8.—Guilhem, P, & Garipuy, A. Accouchement normal chez une XIV" pare atteinte de retieeisseineut mitral congenital Bull. Soc. obst. gyn. Paris, 1934, 23: 59S. Lian, C, & Siguier, F. Maladie de Duroziez; etude etiologique et pathogenique. In Ann.ee med. prat. Par, 1939, 18: 287.— Merklen. Du determinisme de la maladie dc Duroziez, Paris med, 1926, 61: 21 -5.- Scaglia, G. Sulla morfologia e patogenesi del morbo di Duroziez (stenosi mitralica congenita) Minerva med. Tor, 1929, 9: 185-201.—Strauss, H. Duroziez'sche Krankheit und Hvpogenitalismus. Zschr. Kreislaufforsch, 1931, 23: 350-6. ---- Mitral valve: Stenosis: Diagnosis. Nadji, N. I. *Modalites d'auscultation et formes anormales du retrecissement mitral d'apres les signes physiques. 9lp. 8? Par., 1928. Birchard, ('. C. The detection of mitral stenosis. Abstr. ['roc. Ass. Life Insur. M. Dir. America, 1936, 22: 165 -K2. Bjprn-Hansen, H. | Hoeutgenograpliy of lungs m mitral ste- nosis] Norsk mug. liegevid, 1931, 92: 153-5. —Decic, S. Das rnitralstenotische und das mitralkonfigurierte Herz im Profil. fortsch. Hontgenstrahl, 1928, 38: 68-79—Delgado Correa, B, & Maccio, O. La estrechez mitral en el nifio; su frecuencia y diagn6stico. Arch, pediat. Uruguay, 1940, 11: 734-40 — Dietlen, H. Das Rontgenbild der Mitralstenose. Zschr. Kreislaufforsch, 1928, 20: 697-702.—Dumas, A. Le retre- cissement mitral; ses difticultes de diagnostic. J. med. Lyon, 1935, 16: 579 -83. Heidenreich, A. J, & Joselevich, M. Estrechez mitral; doble contorno del perfil derecho de la imagen radiologica del corazon originado por la grasa epipericardica. Sem. med, B. Air, 1938, 45: pt 2, 394-9.—Lutembacher, R. Les modifications du r\ thin de Duroziez et du schema radio- scopique, dans la stenose mitrale. Bull, med. Par, 1940, 54: 107-10.—Pezzi, C. Le tettecissement mitral chez l'enfant: son diagnostic radioscopique. Arch. mal. cceur, 1926, 19: 446-52. ---- Mitral valve: Stenosis: Electrocardiogra- phy. Iriarte, M. Estenosis mitral; estudio clinico sobre 50 casos con 34 electrocardiogramas. 165p. 8? Bilbao [1931] Puhl, H. *Die Mitralstenose unter besonderer Berucksichtigung der elektrokardiographischen Erscheinungen. 24p. 8? [Bonn] 1934. Battro, A. El electrocardiograma de la estrechez mitral Prensa med. argent, 1931-32, 18: 1532-52.—Berliner, K, & Master, A. M. Mitral stenosis; a correlation of electrocardio- graphic and pathologic observations. Arch. Int. M, 1938, 61: 39-59. Also repi.—Castex, M. R, & Battro, A. El electro- cardiograma de la estrechez mitral. Arch. lat. amer. card, Mex, 1931-32, 2: 135-71.— Chvartzman, I. La traduction eiectrocardiographique d'une preponderance auriculaire en particulier dans le retrecissement mitral. Arch. mal. cceur, 1930, 23: 003-19.—Clerc, A, & Schwartzmann, I. Anomalies electrocardiographiques dans le retr6cissement mitral. C. rend. Soc. biol. 1929, 101: 995-8.—Galata, G. Di un segno oscilloscopico della stenosi mitralica. Cuore & circol, 1929, 13: 122-31.—Laubry, C, & Fahrman, J. Considerations sur le svndrome eiectrique du rettecissement mitral. Presse med, 1935, 43: 1937-40.—Matti9li, M. Osservazioni elettrocardio- grafiche nella stenosi mitralica; ricerche su 72 casi. Riforma med, 1938, 54: 1447-51.—Ortega, L, jr. Consideraciones electro-canliogr&ficas de las estenosis mitrales. Rev. mea. cubana, 1931, 45: 516-26. ---- Mitral valve: Stenosis: Etiology. Barber, H. Mitral stenosis due to trauma. Med. J. Aus- tralia, 1938, 1:171. - - - & Osborn, G. R. A case of mitral stenosis the result of trauma. Guv's Hosp. Rep, Lond, 1937, 87: 5H) 5. —Bohan, P. T. etiological factors in mitral stenosis; report of 2 cases. .1. Kansas M. Soc, 1926, 26: 165-7.—Broc, R. Note bur le retrecissement mitral pur chez l'indigene HEART VALVE 399 HEART VALVE musulman. Rev. funis, sc. med, 1928, 22: 98.—Hughes, T. A, & Yusuf, M. Heart disease in the Punjab, with special refer- ence to mitral stenosis. Ind. J. M. Res, 1930, 18: 483-500, 3 pl—Jones, E. W. Aetiology and symptoms of mitral ste- nosis; a review of 300 cases. Brit. M. J, 1933, 1: 307-10 — Moussoir, F. Le rettecissement mitral; conceptions patho- gi'niques et evolution. J. med. chir. Par, 1929, 100: 775-87. Also Rev. med. Par, 1929, 46: 37-58.—Nobecourt, P. L'etio- logie du rettecissement mitral pur des enfants. Bull, med. Par, 1928, 43: 1163-8.—Powers, J. H. The experimental production of mitral stenosis. Arch. Surg, 1929, 18: 1945- 59 —Robertson, D. S. The etiology of mitral stenosis in Manchuria. J. Orient. M, Dairen,1934, 21:99-102.—Stott, H. On rheumatic infection as a cause of mitral stenosis amongst young Indians. Ind. M. Gaz, 1930, 64: 65-7.—Willner, O. Some observations on mitral stenosis and measurements of normals among Chinese. Am. J. M. Se, 1930, 180: 200-12.— Wright, F. J. A case of mitral stenosis in a native girl. East Afr. M. J, 1937-38, 14: 137. ---- Mitral valve: Stenosis, functional. Ludwig, H. Funktionelle Mitralstenosen durch Tumoren des linken Vorhofs. Zschr. klin. Med, 1933, 123: 603-19 — Seyfried, H. Zur Frage der funktionellen Mitralstenose. Munch, med. Wschr, 1937, 84: 1765-7. ---- Mitral valve: Stenosis: Manifestation. Alexeiev, A. G. [Sputum cells in mitral stenosis] Klin. med, Moskva, 1927, 5: _ 377-81.—Almeida Ramos, J. de. Consideragoes clinicas en torno a 31 casos de estenose da mitral. Ann. paul med. cir, 1930, 21: 393-423.—Anglin, A. F. W. Mitral stenosis with chronic passive congestion stimulating miliary tuberculosis. Lancet, Lond, 1938, 2: 717, pl— Castex, M. R, & Beretervide, J. J. El sindrome de angina de pecho en la estrechez mitral. Prensa med. argent, 1928, 15: 497-504.—Colla, IL Contributo alia conoscenza della sindrome mediastinica della stenosi mitralica. Rinasc. med, 1931, 8: 248-50.—Cosio Villegas, I. Algunas consideraciones sobre la estenosis mitral evolutiva. Medicina, Mex, 1926, 9: 133-44.—Cossio, P, & Berconsky, I. The cyanosis in mitral stenosis. Am. Heart J, 1939, 17: 1-9. Also In Libro de oro M. R. Castex, B. Air, 1940, 1: 290-7, tab.—Crespo Alvarez, A, & de Velasco, L. Casuistica de estenosis mitral; estenosis mitral muda; sindrome anginoso en la estenosis mitral; estenosis mitral y enfermedad de Raynaud. Progr. clin, Madr, 1931, 39: 463-9.—Edeiken, J, & Griffith, J. Q, jr. Cyclic pulmonary edema at menses in mitral stenosis; relief following irradiation of pituitary gland. J. Am. M. Ass, 1940, 115: 287-9 — Espejo Sola, J. Presion arterial y venosa periferica en la estenosis mitral y en la arritmia completa. Sem. med, B. Air, 1934, 41: 1937-40.—Estrechez mitral subclfnica. Dia med, B. Air, 1941, 13: 513.—Fahrenkamp, K. Entstehungsmoglich- keiten der Arrhythmia perpetua; ein Beitrag zur Klinik der Mitralstenose. Deut. Arch. klin. Med, 1931, 170: 231-47 — Gravier, L. Forme sympathicotonique du retrecissement mitral; essai de sympathicectomie. Lyon med, 1929, 144: 585-90. ------& Delore, P. Syndrome de Babinski-Nageotte au cours d'un retrecissement mitral; origine embolique probable. Ibid, 1926, 137: 143.—Higgins, J. Sindrome de pseudo- tuberculosis; esttechez mitral. An. Soc. med. quir. Guayas, 1940, 20: 611; 677.—Jervell, O, & Grytting, G. [Symptoma- tology of mitral stenosis] Norsk mag. laegevid, 1938, 99: 1337-52.—Jona, G. Stenosi mitralica a forma emoftoica, Policlinico, 1932, 39: sez. prat, 877-82.— Kleiber, E. E. Long standing productive cough as chief clinical manifestation in mitral stenosis; a case complicated by thrombosis of left auricle. Ann. Int. M, 1941-42, 15: 899-910.—Landoln, M. La sindrome mediastinica della stenosi mitralica pura. Riforma med, 1929, 45: 1017.—Langeron, L. Note sur le mecanisme de production des signes physiques du rettecissement mitral. J. sc. med. Lille, 1928, 46: pt 2, 15-7.—Lutembacher, R. Stenose mitrale et visage pale. Bull, med. Par, 1938, 52: 960-2.—Mathieu, L. Le petit tettecissement mitral (formes cliniques et diagnostic) Rev. med. est, 1926, 54: 376-80.— Montes Pareja, J. Le syndrome d'angine de poitrine dans le rettecissement mitral. Paris med, 1927, 63: 256-9.—Morelli, A. C. La estenosis mitral incipiente en el adulto. Arch. urug. med, 1940, 17: 581-6.—Nobecourt. La forme discrete ou occulte de la maladie mitrale chez l'enfant. Rev. gen. clin. ther, 1935, 49: 513-20.—Picchini, G. Le modificazioni attive della sonoriti paravertebral; polmonare nella stenosi mitralica. Gior. clin. med, 1932, 13: 163-77.- Polevski, J. Significance and diagnosis of silent mitral stenosis. J. M. Soc. N. Jersey, 1931, 2o: 910-4.—Raimondi, A. A, Capdehourat, E, & Mazzei, E. S. Estrechez mitral simulando. tuberculosis. Dia med, B. Air, 1930-31, 3: 501.—Schutte, J. F. La estenosis mitral fifona; su manifestaci6n en forma de insuficiencia auricular. Rev. med. cubana, 1934, 45: 559-96.—Schwartz, S. P. Dis- placement of the left nipple in mitral stenosis. Am. Heart Dis, 1929-30, 5: 344.—Trunecek, C, & Lepicovsky, G. La pulsazione visible deU'orecehietta sinistra. Riforma med, 1932, 48: 1091-3.—Valdes Lambea. La febricula en los enfermos con estenosis del orificio auriculo-ventricular izquierdo; sobre el abuso del diagnostico de tuberculosis. Arch, med, Madr, 1935, 38: 537. Also Siglo med, 1935, 96: 325. ;------Una enferma de estenosis mitral, trombopenica, intensamente hemopt6ica. Med. ibera, 1935, 29: 501.—Warburg, E. Hiimo- ptysis als Initialsymptom bei Mitralstenose. Acta med. scand }932 79: Suppl. 50, 67-84. Also Hospitalstidende, 1932, 75: ---- Mitral valve: Stenosis: Manifestation, auscultatory. See also Heart sound, Murmur. Rossner, G. * Ueber die Eigenschaften des prasystolischen Gerausches bei Mitralstenose. 26p. 8? Gott., 1929. Tchang, P. V. *Contribution a l'etude des formes silencieuses du retrecissement mitral; le retrecissement mitral secondairement silencieux. 77p. 8? Lyon, 1937. Antonelli, G. Sul significato del cosl detto rumore pre- sistolico nella stenosi mitralica, particolarmente nei casi con aritmia completa. Cuore & circol, 1936, 20: 162-93.— Babonneix, L, & Mornet, J. Stenose mitrale aphone. Bull. Soc. med. hop. Paris, 1927, 3. ser, 51: 315-8.—Bass, E, & Rossner, G. Ueber die Eigenschaften des prasvstDlischen Gerausches bei Mitralstenose. Zschr. ges. exp. Med, 1929, 68: 673T89.—Battro, A, & Braun-Menendez, E. Estudio fonocardiograJfico de la estrechez mitral Rev. argent, card, 1937-38, 4: 1-19. Also Boll Accad. med. Roma, 1938, 64: 15-7.—Bland, E. F, White, P. D, & Jones, T. D. The develop- ment of mitral stenosis in young people with a discussion of the frequent misinterpretation of a middiastolic murmur at the cardiac apex. Am. Heart J, 1934-35, 10: 995-1004.—Cossio, P. Comentarios sobre los fenomenos acusticos de la estrechez mitral y de algunos ruidos de soplo, segtin el registro grafico de los mismos. Rev. argent, card, 1937-38, 4: 301; 383.— Dressier, W. Ueber die Entstehung des pathognomonischen Crescendo-Gerausches bei der Stenose des Mitralostiums. Wien. klin. Wschr, 1928, 41: 1245-9.—Dumas, A, & Benoit. Retrecissement mitral secondairement silencieux. Lyon med, 1933, 152: 747-51.—Dumas, A, & Bourret, J. Retre- cissement mitral silencieux par immobilisation complete de la valvule. Ibid, 1936, 157:593-8.—Duchosal, P. Les dedouble- ments de 2e bruit du cceur dans la stenose mitrale et leur enregistrement phonographique. Bull. Soc. med. hop. Paris, 1934, 3. ser, 50: 398-402.—Eggleston, C. The persistence of a mitral stenotic murmur in the presence of auricular fibrillation. Tr. Ass. Am. Physicians, 1928, 43: 36-48.—Eimer, K. Ueber die Entstehung des Crescendogerausches bei der Mitralstenose. Deut. Arch. klin. Med, 1928, 159: 164-70.—Ferrannini, A. Sui sintomi di ascoltazione nella stenosi mitralica. Riforma med, 1936, 52: 782.—Flaxman, N. Variability of murmurs in mitral stenosis. Am. J. M. Sc, 1935, 190: 396-9. Also repr — Gaafar, M. Conduction of diastolic murmurs in mitral stenosis to the back. J. Egypt. M. Ass, 1933, 16: 418-20.—Gotsch, K. Zur Frage der Entstehung des Crescendogerausches der Mitral- stenose. Deut. Arch. klin. Med, 1933, 175: 241-3.—Herkel, W, & Zur, G. Herzschallstudien bei Mitralstenose. Zschr. klin. Med, 1939-40, 137: 145-69.—Johnston, F. D. The value of sound records in the diagnosis of mitral stenosis. Am. Heart J, 1934-35, 10: 654-61. Also repr.—Khavkin, A. B. [Normal first sound in decompensated mitral stenosis] Vrach. delo, 1929, 12: 649.—Laubry, C, Boutier, D, & Lenegre. Retrecissement mitral et souffle diastolique. Gaz. hop, 1932, 105: 1649-51.—Lian, C. Le bruit de rappel de retrecissement mitral (remarques cliniques et phonocardiographiques) Bull. Soc. med. hop. Paris, 1934, 3. ser, 50: 39-46.—Lubienicki, H. [Changes of the diastolic murmur in stenosis of the mitral valve] Polskie arch. med. wewn, 1932, 10: 618-23.—Lutembacher, R. Stenose mitrale silencieuse et syndrome tricuspidien terminal Arch. mal. coeur, 1930, 23: 782-6. ------ Rythme de Duro- ziez k renforcement diastolique dans la stenose mitrale. Ibid, 1931, 24: 190-4. ------ Le souffle diastolique de la stenose mitrale. Presse med, 1940, 48: 1021-3.—Margolies, A, & Wolferth, C. C. The opening snap (claquement d'ouverture de la mitrale) in mitral stenosis, its characteristics, mechanism of production and diagnostic importance. Am. Heart J, 1932, 7: 443-70.—Migliori, V. Le modificazioni del reperto ascoltatorio cardiaco provocate con la manovra del Dagnini, compressione dei bulbi oculari, nella stenosi mitralica, pura o associata nell'infanzia. Clin, pediat. Mod, 1939, 21: 309-30.—■ Mozer, J. J, & Duchosal, P. Etude eiectro-phonocardio- graphique du rythme de retrecissement mitral. Arch. mal. coeur, 1930, 23: 74-80.—Pereiras, R. La estrechez mitral muda. Cron. med. quir. Habana, 1932, 58: 43-52, pl— Routier, D, & Mevel, Y. Souffle diastolique et tettecissement mitral Rev. med. Par, 1930, 47: 267-71.—Sani, A. La stenosi mitralica muta. Riv. med, 1933, 41: 49.— Satke, O. Ueber die Entstehung des prasystolischen Kres- zendogerausches bei der Stenose des Mitralostiums. Wien. klin. Wschr, 1934, 47: 1196-8.—Tardieu, A, & Grain, R. Retrecissement mitral fruste et troubles phonatoires. Bull. Soc. med. Paris, 1930, 478-82.—Thur, W. Eine Art von Flintschem Gerausch bei einer Mitralstenose. Wien. klin. Wschr, 1929, 42: 1438.—Tremolieres, F, & Salmon, A. R. Un cas de rettecissement mitral silencieux. Bull. Soc. med. hop. Paris, 1927, 3. ser, 51: 1100-3.—Yostiioka, J. Analytical investigation into the acoustic phenomena in mitral stenosis. Acta Scholar med. Univ. Kioto, 1931-32, 14: 317-21. HEART VALVE 400 HEART VALVE ---- Mitral valve: Stenosis: Manifestation: Laryngeal paralysis [Ortner's syndrome] Aubriot, P., Mathieu, L, & Herbeuval, R. Coincidence d'un retrecissement mitral avec arythmie complete et d'une paralysic rocurrentiele avec dysphagie et syndrome d'hemi- thermoanalgesie alterne par svndrome bulbaire tetro-olivaire. Rev. med. Nancy, 1939, 67: 30-4— Babonneix, L., Gole, L, & Rudnanski. Paralysie tecurrentielle gauche temporaire au cours dune maladie mitrale chez une filette de 10 ans. Bull. Soc. pediat. Paris, 1934, 32: 463-5.—Babonneix, Guilly & Rudnansky. Paralvsie tecurrentielle gauche au cours d'une maladie mitrale. Gaz. hop, 1934, 107: 1652.—Bonan, H., & Uzan, M. Rettecissement mitral et paralysie tecurrentielle. J. med. Paris, 1927, 46: 158.—Cola, F. Paralisi del ricorrente da stenosi mitralica (contributo clinico) Gior. med. mil, 1928, 76: 522-30.—Eizaguirre, L. Estrechez mitral con signo de Ortner. Med. ibera, 1935, 29: pt 1, 465-7.—Fontan, A, & Broustet, P. Paralysie tecurrentielle et syndrome rseudo- cavitaire au cours dun rettecissement mitral. J. med. Bor- deaux, 1928, 58: 527-30.—Grosse-Oetringhaus. Ueber Lah- mung des linkseitigen Nervus recunens bei Mitralvitium. Deut. med. Wschr, 1930, 56: 1910.—Langeron. L. Re- trecissement mitral; paralysie tecurrcutielle; svndrome de Claude Bernard-Horner. Bruxelles med, 1928-29, 9: 163-5.— Reiche, F. Linksseitige Itelui renslahmung bei Mitralstenose. Med. Klin, Berl, 1920, 22: 1142— Silvagni, M. Le lesioni del nervo ricorrente nei vizi mitralici. Arch. ital. laring, 1928, 47: 129-51, ch.—Terzani, A. Sopra un caso di sindrome di Ortner; paralisi del ricorrente in corso di stenosi mitralica. Riv. clin. med, 1940, 41: 423-9. ---- Mitral valve: Stenosis: Manifestation, pulmonary. Rosen, J. S. *De l'oedeme pulmonaire dans la stenose mitrale. 40p. 8? Lausanne, 1936. Roucho.v, L. *Du role de la stenose mitrale dans la genese de l'oedeme aigu du poumon. 83p. 8? Par., 1926. Broustet, P. Pathogenie de l'oedeme aigu pulmonaire du tetrccissement mitral Paris med, 1938, 107: 380-5.—Csus- sade, G, & Tardieu, A. Poussees congestives pulmonaires tuberculeuses tepetees au cours d'un retrecissement mitral. Bull Soc. med. hop. Paris, 1927, 3. ser, 51 : 593-8.—Dargein & Dore, G. R. Oedeme aigu du poumon dans le retrecissement initial. Ibid, 1926, 3. ser, 50: 894-6.—Dominguez, C. En- fermedad mitral; esclerosis secundaria de la arteria pulmonar; fi1>rilact6n auricular. Dia med, B. Air, 1929-30, 2: 903.— Doumer, E. L'cedeme aigu du poumon dans le rettecissement mitral en dehors de la grossesse. Arch. mal. coeur, 1926, 19: 791-6.—Eyherabide. R, Mazzei, E. S, & Pittaluga Nogura, E. Estrechez mitral de forma edematosa (edema aguda del pulmon recidivante en la estrechez mitral) Rev. As. med. argent, 1936, 50: 67-72.—Froge & Chiniara, J. Crises d'oedeme aigu du poumon et de la retine chez un patient atteint de retrecisse- ment mitral. Bull. Soc. opht. Paris, 1936, 338-41.—Ginsberg, A. M. Hemoptysis in mitral stenosis; with report of 2 cases; one with fatal hemorrhage. J. Missouri M. Ass, 1930, 27: 205-9.- Giroux, R. L'oedeme aigu du poumon dans le re- trecissement mitral Bull, med. Par, 1927, 41: 354.—Hess, L. Ueber Lungeuodem bei Mitralstenose. W'ien. klin. Wschr, 1931, 44: 508 -13.—Izzo, R. A. Estrechez mitral y tuberculosis pulmonar. Lev. Soc. med. int., B. Air, 1926, 2: 528-37.— Jona, G. Stenosi mitralica a forma emoftoica; induramento bruno del polmone, calcificante. Policlinico, 1933, 40: sez. prat, 1679-85.—Laubry, C, & Thomas, M. Les lesions de l'artere pulmonaire et leurs consequences au cours du retrecisse- ment mitral Bull. Soc. med. hop. Paris, 1926, 3. ser, 50: 639-47.—McGinn, S, & White, P. D. Acute pulmonary congestion and cardiac asthma in patients with mitral stenosis. Am. Heart J, 1934, 9: 697-705.—Macit Arif Emir. Un cas de maladie mitrale avec image pulmonaire finement nodulaire chez un mineur. Ann. med. Par, 1939-40, 46: 232-7.— Parker, F, jr, & Weiss, S. The nature arid significance of the structural changes in the lungs in mitral stenosis. Am. J. Path, 1936, 12: 573-98, 8 pl—Pons, A. P, & Amell Sans, A. Granulia pulmonar hemosiderosica en una estenosis mitral. Hev. As. med. argent, 1936, 50: 1385-94.—Raimondi, A. A, Capdehourat, E, & Mazzei, E. S. Pseudo-tuberculosis por estrechez mitral Rev. Soc. med. int., B. Air, 1931, 7: 145-52.—Ruiz de Guardia, J. Estenosis mitral y tuberculosis. Rev. hig. tuberc, Valencia, 1929, 22: 347-50.—Schellong, F. Akute Lungenstauung und Lungenodem bei Mitralstenose (Sonderstelluug dieses Klappenfehlers) Klin. Wschr, 1933, 12: 18-22.—Stein, S. C, & Giering, J. F. Cardiac thrombi complicating initial stenosis with pulmonary tuberculosis in a miner. Pennsylvania M. J, 1940-41, 44:. 183-5. Also repr.— Stewart, H. J. The occurrence of "hemoptysis as a symptom of acute heart failure in the presence of mitral stenosis. Med Clin. N. America, 1934, 18: 917-34.—Thums, K. Akutes Lungeuodem bei Mitralstenose. Klin. Wsehr, 1933, 12: 1644-8.—Valdes Lambea. Estenosis mitral v tuberculosis Med. ibera, 1934, 28: pt 2, 205-12. ------■ Una enferma de estenosis mitral trombopenica, intensamente hemopt6ica Siglo med, 1935, 95: 168. ---- Mitral valve: Stenosis: Pathology. SoulIs, C. *.V propos de certaines modahtes evolutive* des stenoses mitrales, stenoses mitrales vieillies, stenoses mitrales rcmaniees. 91p. S" Par., 1935. Aquino, P. B, iV Espejo Sola, J. Estenosis mitral muv acentuada. Dia med, B. Air, 1932 33, 5: 625. - Bland. E. F, Balboni, G. M, & White. P. I). Krnormous increase of heart volume with mitral stenosis; report of a case. J. Am. l\I. Asm, 1931, 96: 840-3.—Eliaschewitsch. P. A. Ueber ungewohnliclie I.ungenarterien- und Herzveranderungen bei Mitralstenose (zugleich ein Beitrag zur Kenntnis der Endokardverdickungen und des Endokards selbst) Virchows Arch, 1930-31, 279: 436-63.—Fernando, P. B. Clinical and postmortem notes on 5 cases of mitral stenosis treated in the General Hospiial, Colombo. J. Ceylon Br. M. Ass, 1934, 31: 3176.- -Galavotti, B. Stenosi mitralica senza dilatazione dell'atrio sinistro. Bull. sc. med, Bologna, 19:>S, 110: 334 46— Goedel, A. Eine ungewohnliclie Form der Herzvergrosserung (enorme Vorhofvergrosserung) bei Mitralstenose. Wien. klin. Wschr, 1929, 42: 427-30.—Held, I. W, Goldbloom, A. A, it l.ieberson, A. Tight (non-regurgitant) mitral stenosis; a clinico-patho- logical study. Am. J. M. Sc, 1935, 190: 791-805, pl- Held, I. W, Goldbloom, A. A, & Rittenberg, L. M. Mitral stenosis with special reference to buttonhole mitral stenosis. Med. Clin. N. America, 1931, 14: 1311-34.—Londres, G„ de Senna, M, & de Lima Filho, A. Sopra circular de Miguel Couto. J. clin, Rio, 1934, 15: 181-3.—Nelson, R. L. Left auricle with a capacity of 1,695 grams of blood in a ease of mitral stenosis. Am. Heart J, 1940, 20: 627-33.—Plenczner. 8. [Pathology, clinic and pathophysiology of the bicuspidal steno- sis] Budapesti orv. ujs, 1940, 38: 61; 76.—Pruche, A. Re- trecissement mitral decompense. Clinique, Par, 1932, 27: 297.—Soukup, V. [Mitral stenosis] Cas. 16k. cesk, 1932, 71: 1231.—Stone, C. S, & Feil, H. S. Mitral stenosis; a clinical and pathological study of 100 cases. Am. Heart J, 1933, 9: 53-62. ---- Mitral valve: Stenosis: Physiopathology. Amic. Le retrecissement mitral hypertensif. Lyon med, 1938, 162: 703-7.—Brumlik, J. [Circulatory dynamics in mitral stenosis] Sborn. lek, 1933, 35: 1-55— Brumm, H. J, & Smith, H. L. Hypertension associated with mitral stenosis; report of 44 cases. Minnesota M, 1941, 24: 664.—Chiovenda, M. 0 coracao venoso pulmonar na estenose mitral; importancia das venulas pulmonares na compensacao da pequena circulacao. Resenha clin. cient, S. Paulo, 1940, 9: 325-30.—Cioni, C, & Sirtori, C. Le vene polmonari di grande e medio calibro nella stenosi mitralica; ricerche sistematiche, con riferimenti alia patologia del piccolo circolo. Arch. ital. anat. pat, 1938-39, 9: 613-57.—Cossio, P, & Berconsky, I. La presipn venosa en miembros superiores e inferiores en el agrandanuenio de la auricula izquierda; mecanismo de la cianosis en la estrechez mitral. Rev. argent, card, 1939-40, 6: 137-45.—Dc Matteis, F. Ipertensione arteriosa e stenosi mitralica. Minerva med. Tor, 1938, 29: 273-8.—Fahrenkamp, K. Die praktische Bedeutung der Mitralstenose. Aerztl. Rdsch, 1926, 36: 125- 9.—Goyena, J. R, Bianchi, A. E, & Naveiro Orfila, R. Las venas pulmonares en la estrechez mitral Adas Congr. nac. med, B. Air, (1931) 1932, 4. Congr, pt 2, 69-81. Also An. Inst. clin. med, B. Air, 1931, 12: 49.—Gurich. 1st die Lclnc von der Kompensation noch aufrecht zu erhalten'.' die Mitral- stenose. Verh. Deut. Ges. Kreislaufforsch, 1928, 75.—Gupta, J. C. Hypertension bei Mitralstenose. Zschr. Kreislaufforsch, 1934, 26: 293-308—Katz, L. N, & Siegel, M. L. The cardio- dynamic effects of acute experimental mitral stenosis. Am. Heart J, 1931, 6: 672-82.—Kerkhof, A. C. Minute volume determinations in mitral stenosis during auricular fibrillation and after restoration of normal rhythm. Ibid, 1936, 11: 206- 11.—Levine, S. A, & Fulton, M. N. The relation of hyper- tension to mitral stenosis. Tr. Ass. Am. Physicians, 1928, 43: 31-5.—Lian, C. & Barrieu, R. Rettecissement mitral et hyper- tension arterielle. Bull, med. Par, 1929, 43: 117.—Meakins, J, Dautrebande, L, & Fetter, W. J. The influence of circula- tory disturbances on the gaseous exchange of the blood; the blood gases and circulation rate in eases of mitral stenosis. Heart, Lond, 1922-23, 10: 153-78.—Naveiro, R. Fisio- patologia de la pequena circulacion en la estrechez mitral Sem. med, B. Air, 1931, 38: pt 2, 957; 1050.—Powers, J. H, Pilcher, C, & Bowie, M. A. Some observations on the circula- tion in experimental mitral stenosis. Am. J. Physiol, 1931, 96: 405-11.—Schiassi, F. La mancata dilatazione deU'orecehietta sinistra nella stenosi mitralica. Bull. sc. med, Bologna, 1938, 110: 83-93. ---- Mitral valve: Stenosis: Treatment. See also Heart, Surgery. Allen, D. S, & Barker, P. S. Surgery of the mitral valve; an experimental electrocardiographic study. Am. Heart J, 1925- 26, 1: 693-702.—Bailey, H. Mitral stenosis with congestive heart failure treatel by complete thyroidectomy. Proc. R. Soc. M, Lond, 1935-36, 29:41.------& Garland, A. Mitral stenosis and congestive heart failure treated by complete I thyroidectomy. Ibid, 1936-37, 30: 157.—Bourne, G. The HEART VALVE 401 HEART VALVE surgical treatment of mitral stenosis. S. Barth. Hosp. J, Lond, 1927-28, 35: 22-4.—Cavarozzi, N. Turbe circolatorie indotte dal pneumotorax terapeutico in un caso di stenosi mitralica. Riv. pat. app. resp, 1934, 3: 720-35.—Cutler, E. C. The surgical aspect of mitral stenosis. Arch. Surg, 1926, 12: 212- 29.—Delageniere, Y. Une observation de pericardiolyse pour symphyse cardiaque avec retrecissement mitral; guerison fonctionnelle tardive, mais complete; etude d'un procede possible de valvulotomie mitrale. P. verb. Congr. fr. chir, 1932, 41: 289-300.—Gallavardin, L, Gravier, L, & Wertheimer, P. Point de cote auriculaire dorsal droit au cours du retrecisse- ment mitral; essai de traitement chirurgical. Medecine, Par, 1933, 14: 181-6.—Godel, R. Les formes frustes du retrecisse- ment mitral et leur traitement. Gaz. med. France, 1929, 3: 341-4.—Gosmann, W. Zur Klinik der Mitralstenose auf Grund quantitativer Digitalis-(Strophanthin-)Therapie. Klin. Wschr, 1931, 10: 2332-6.—Jarotzky, A. Zur Frage der Ope- ration im Innern des Herzens bei Stenosis mitralis. Zbl. Chir, 1926, 53: 140-2.—Powers, J. H. Surgical treatment of mitral stenosis; an experimental study. Arch. Surg, 1932, 25: 555. Also repr.—Pribram, B. O. Die operative Behandlung der Mitralstenose. Arch. klin. Chir, 1926, 142: 458-65 [Discussion] 71. Also Schweiz. med. Wschr, 1926, 56: 1201 — Seneque, J. Traitement chirurgical de la stenose mitrale. Presse med, 1926, 34: 597.—Valerio, A. A cirurgia na estenose mitral. Brasil med, 1929, 43: 827.—Wilson, W. C. Studies in experimental mitral obstruction in relation to the surgical treatment of mitral stenosis. Brit. J. Surg, 1930, 18: 259-74. ---- Mitral valve: Stenosis—in the pregnant. See also Heart failure—in the pregnant. Herrmann, A. *Zur Bewertung der Mitral- stenose in der Schwangerschaft. 32p. 8? Bonn, 1933. Oeken, J. ^Mitralstenose und Schwanger- schaft [Wurzburg] 16p. 8? Dillingen, 1931. Sejotjrne, J. *Le retrecissement mitral dans ses rapports avec l'etat puerperal. 156p. 8? Par., 1928. Brahic, J, & Gayraud, L. Retrecissement mitral et grossesse. Rev. fr. gyn. obst, 1927, 22: 103-7.—Casiello, A, & Hanono, M. Cardiopatias y embarazo; embarazo y parto normal en una estenosis mitral despues de 14 abortos terapeuticos. Rev. med. Rosario, 1939, 29: 226-31.—Dmitrenko, L. F. [Mitral stenosis and pregnancy] Radianska med, 1939, 4: No. 10, 27-30.—Gerich, O. Die reine Mitralstenose und Schwanger- schaft. Mschr. Geburtsh. Gyn, 1927, 77: 413-22.—Jaschke, R. T. von. Schwangerschaft und Mitralstenose. Zbl. Gyn, 1927, 51: 1354-6.—Navarro Blasco, D. A. Estenosis mitral v embarazo. Arch, med, Madr, 1935, 38: 403-5. Also Med. ibera, 1935, 29: 837-40.—Webster, S. J., & Morgan, J. E. Pregnancy complicated by mitral stenosis and toxemia. Ohio M. J, 1937, 33: 1225.—Zinsstag, G. Schwangerschaft und Mitralstenose. Mschr. Geburtsh. Gyn, 1926-27, 75: 498- 508. ---- Pulmonic valve. See Pulmonary artery. ---- Rupture. See also Heart muscle, Papillary muscle: Avulsion. Briel, R. *Ueber traumatische Herzklappen- rupturen [Tubingen] 30p. 8? Ehingen, 1937. Antonini, A. Le rotture traumatiche delle valvole cardiache. Clin. med. ital, 1931, 62: 972-1004. ---- semilunar. Brites, G. Sur les anomalies numeriques des valvules des orifices arteriels du cceur de I'homme. Fol. anat. Univ. Conimbr, 1937, 12: No. 8, 1-136, 16 pl—Carpenter, G. Aorta arising from both ventricles; small pulmonary artery with two semilunar valves; patent ductus arteriosus; semilunar valve efficiently guarding foramen ovale, but displaying a tiny perforation. Rep. Soc. Study Dis. Child, Lond, 1907-8, 8: 228-31, 2 pl—Costa, A. Studio sulle trasposizioni degli osti arteriosi; reperti anatomo-patologici per la critica della teoria filogenetica. Sperimentale, 1934, 88: 37-72.—Foxe, A. N. Fenestrations of the semilunar valves. Am. J. Path, 1929, 5: 179-82.—Hochrein, M. Der Mechanismus der Semilunar- klappen des Herzens. Deut. Arch. klin. Med, 1926-27, 154: 131-64.—OertebO. Ueber Reduktion der Valvulae semilunares, a. pulmonalis auf zwei (mit Erorterung der teratogenetischen Terminationsperiode) Zschr. ges. Anat, 1. Abt, 1927, 84: 153-9.—Santa Cruz, J. Z. A case of common ventricular opening for the aorta and pulmonary artery. J. Philippine Islands M. Ass, 1925, 5: 295-300. ---- Surgery. Lenormand. Chirurgie du cceur; chirurgie des tumeurs et des rettecissements valvulaires du coeur. Gaz. hop, 1932, 105: 1589-94. Also Paris med, 1932, 85: annexe, 331-8. Also Rev. gen chn. ther, 1932, 46: Suppl, 2379.—Murray, G, Wilkinson, F. R, & MacKenzie, R. Reconstruction of the valves of the heart. Canad. M. Ass. J, 1938, 38: 317-9.—Ruggieri, E. Sguardo d'insieme alia chirurgia sperimentale e clinica delle valvole cardiache. Arch. ital. chir, 1932, 32: 55-68. ---- Tricuspid valve. Saijo, Y. Demonstration der Oeffnungswelle der Trikuspi- dalklappe (uber ein Epigastriogramm mit gleichzeitiger Registrierung des Jugularvenenpulses) Nagoya J. M. Sc, ---- Tricuspid valve: Abnormity. Schonenberger. F. *Ueber einen Fall von hochgradiger Missbildung der Tricuspidalklappe mit Insufficienz derselben. 32p. 8? Ziir., 1903. Amolsch, A. L. Congenital atresia of the tricuspid valve, complicated by congenital myxosarcoma of the labium majus. Arch. Path, Chic, 1937, 24: 777-85.—Arnstein, A. Eine seltene Missbildung der Trikuspidalklappe (Ebsteinsche Krankheit) Virchows Arch, 1927, 266: 247-54.—Bellet, S, & Stewart, H. L. Congenital heart disease; atresia of the tricuspid orifice. Am. J. Dis. Child, 1933, 45: 1247-52.— Breslich, P. J. Congenital atresia of the tricuspid orifice. Tr. Chicago Path. Soc, 1930, 13: 307-14. Also Arch. Path, Chic, 1930, 10: 206-12.—Brown, J. W. Congenital tricuspid atresia. Arch. Dis. Childh, Lond, 1936, 11: 275-80.— Cathala, J, & Tisserand. Les attesies congenitales de la val- vule tricuspide (a propos d'un cas d'attesie partielle avec cyanose paroxystique) Rev. fr. pediat, 1926, 2: 343-9. Also Bull. Soc. med. hop. Paris, 1926, 3. ser, 50: 501-5.—Gotz, H. Tricuspidalinsuffizienz infolge Verlagerung der Segel und Ausbleiben der Endothelrohrdifferenzierung. Virchows Arch, 1933, 291: 835-53.—Lutz, J. J. Perforate posterior tricuspid leaflet (double tricuspid orifice) Tr. Chicago Path. Soc, 1928- 29, 13: 143-5.—Moser, A. Ueber angeborenes Fehlen des Ostium tricuspidale. Zschr. Kreislaufforsch, 1936, 28: 521- 32.—Murphy, G. R, & Bleyer, L. F. Atresia of the tricuspid orifice. Am. J. Dis. Child, 1933, 46: 350-5.—Obiditsch, R. A. Ueber eine Missbildung der Tricuspidalklappen. Virchows Arch, 1939, 304: 97-105.—Rihl, J, Terplan, K, & Weiss, F. Ueber einen Fall von Agenesie der Tricuspidalklappe. Med. Klin, Berl, 1929, 25: 1543-5.—Rossi, G. Su di una complessa viziatura di cuore secondaria ad atresia dell'ostio atrio-ventri- colare destro. Osp. maggiore Novara, 1939, 16: 581-90.— Sakaki, J. Ein Sektionsfall von seltener Herzmissbildung (sogenannter Tricuspidalatresie) Tr. Soc. path, jap, 1937, 27: 388.—Sales, G, & Florand, J. Un cas de cyanose congenitale par atresie tricuspidienne (atropine du, ventricule droit, com- munication interauriculaire et interventriculaire, persistance du canal arteriel) Bull. Soc. pediat. Paris, 1923, 21: 35-42.— Taussig, H. B. The clinical and pathological findings in con- genital malformations of the heart due to defective develop- ment of the right ventricle associated with tricuspid atresia or hypoplasia. Bull. Johns Hopkins Hosp, 1936, 59: 435-44, pl.—Yater, W. M, & Shapiro, M. J. Congenital displacement of the tricuspid valve, Ebstein's disease; review and report of a case with electrocardiographic abnormalities and detailed his- tologic study of the conduction system. Ann. Int. M, 1937- 38, 11: 1043-62.—Zink, A. Ueber einen Fall von trichter- formiger Tricuspidalklappe (Ebstein'sche Krankheit) mit offenem Foramen ovale. Virchows Arch, 1937, 299: 235-52. ---- Tricuspid valve: Disease. Castex, M. R, Battro, A, & Quirno, N. El diagnostico de las lesiones tricuspideas organicas adquiridas. Rev. argent. card, 1937-38, 4: 113-31.—Cataldi, G. M. Sui vizi organici della tricuspide. Arch. sc. med. Tor, 1934, 58: 205-36 — Changli-Chaikin, P. F. [The mechanism of compensation in defects of the tricuspid valve] Dnipropetr. med. J, 1926, 5: 584-92.—Friedlander, R. D. Acquired lesions of the tricuspid valve. California West. M, 1938, 49: 110.—Holzmann, M. Rontgenbefunde bei Trikuspidalfehlern. Fortsch. Ront- genstrahl, 1932, 46: 14-22.—Kerr, W. J, & Morrison, L. F. Tricuspid disease. California West. M, 1927, 26: 193-5 — Wichterlova, M. [Diagnosis of affections of the tricuspid valve] Cas. lek. desk, 1934, 73: 176; 211. ---- Tricuspid valve: Insufficiency. Neumann, J. *Venenpuls und Trikuspidal- insuffizienz [Wurzburg] 15p. 8? Lpz., 1914. Aguirre, R. S, & Mosto, D. Insuficiencia tricuspidea org&nica y arteritis de la arteria pulmonar por infeccion reuma- tismal. Arch, argent, pediat, 1933, 4 289-504. Also Sem. med, B. Air, 1933, 40: 491-9.—Donovan, A. E. B. Primary tricuspid incompetency. Native M. Pract, Suva, 1935, 2: 352.—Dressier, W. Pulsations of the wall of the chest; pulsations associated with tricuspid regurgitation. Arch. Int. M, 1937, 60: 441-8.—Fingerhuth, M, & Bickenbach, O. Beitrag zur Klinik der Tricuspidalinsuffizienz. Deut. Arch. klin. Med, 1933, 175: 577-613.—Fischer, R. Ein Fall von organischer Trikuspidaliiisuffizienz. Wien. klin. Wschr, 1928, 41: 657-9. ------ Epikrise eines Falles von Trikuspidalin- suffizienz. Ibid, 1933, 46: 1544-7. •------ Demonstration eines Falles von Trikuspidalinsumzienz. Wien. med. Wschr, 227475—vol. 1, 4th series----26 HEART VALVE 402 HEART VENTRICLE 1927. 77: I704.r-Giroux, R., & Katsilabros, L. Contribution k l'etude des signes cliniques de l'insuffisance tricuspidienne fonctionnelle. Bull, med. Par, 192S, 42: 694-6.—Hildebrand, K. H. Pulsatorische Phanomene im peripheren Venen gebiet bei 'I'rikuspidalinsuffizienz, Analyse der beim Zustandekommen dieses Venenpulses massgeblichen Faktoren. Verh. Deut. Ges. Kreislaufforsch, 1936, 9: 353-8.—Jacobi, J, Janker, R., & Schmitz, W. Rontgenologische und elektrokardiographische Beobachtungen bei experimenteller Tricuspidalinsuffizienz. Deut. Arch. klin. Med, 1931-32, 172: 508-10.—Jacobi, J, & Wassermeyer, H. Ueber die Chemie der Hypertrophie und Atropine muskularer Organe; der rechte Ventrikel bei Tri- cuspidalisinsuffizienz. Arch. exp. Path, Lpz, 1930, 157: 234-43.—Laubry, C, & Routier, D. Insuffisance tricuspidienne. Bull, med. Par, 1928, 42: 91.—Pallasse, E, & Bret, J. Con- tribution k l'etude de l'insuffisance t rieuspidienne fonctionnelle. Lyon med, 1934, 154: 110-3.—Segura, G. Insuficiencia tricuspldea organica solitaria. Lev. Soc. med. int., B. Air, 1931, 7: 29-38.—Wilk, N. L, & Rabinovich, N. P. [Isolated insufficiency of the tricuspid valve of traumatic origin] Klin. med, Moskva, 1939, 17: 131-4. ---- Tricuspid valve: Stenosis. Altschule, M. D, & Blumgart, H. L. The circulatory dynamics in tricuspid stenosis; their significance in the patho- genesis of edema and orthopnea. Am. Heart J, 1937, 13: 589-98.—Chilikin, W. I. Zur klinischen Charakteristik der Trikuspidalstenose. Zschr. Kreislaufforsch, 1930, 22: 177-88 [Erwiderung von W. Dressier, & R. Fischer] 188-90.—Clements, A. B. Isolated tricuspid stenosis of probable rheumatic origin; report of a case with unusual clinical and pathological findings. Am. J. M. Sc, 1935, 190: 389-96, 2 pl—Friedlander, R. D, & Kerr, W. J. The clinical diagnosis of tricuspid stenosis; report of a case complicated bv paroxysmal nodal tachycardia and A-V dissociation. Am. Heart J, 1936, 11: 357; 1938, 15: 625. Also repr.—Kreutzer, R. Sobre un probable caso de estrechez o de atresia tiicuspidea congenita. Arch, argent. pediat, 1939, 11: 301-7.—Taussig, B. L. A case of tricuspid stenosis with enormous dilatation of the right auricle. Am. Heart J, 1937, 14: 744-52.—Zeisler, E. B. Tricuspid stenosis; review of the literature and report of a case with antemortem diagnosis. Ibid, 1933, 8: 697-704. venous. Gatzi, M. W. *Recherches sur les valvules veineuses et sigmoides du coeur humain et de quelques animaux domestiques [Geneve] p.367- 446. Strasb., 1929. Also Arch, anat, Strasb, 1929-30, 10: 367-446. Pan, N. Remnants of the venous valves in the adult heart. J. Anat, Lond, 1935-36, 70: 435-8.—Yater, W. M. Variations and anomalies of the venous valves of the right atrium of the human heart. Arch. Path, Chic, 1929, 7: 418-41. Also repr. HEART ventricle. See also Heart chambers; Heart function; Heart muscle, &c. Huwyler, B. *Zur Anatomie des Schweine- herzens; Untersuchungen des Kammerinnern bei Sus scrofa domesticus [Zurich] 32p. 8° Weimar, 1926. Also Anat. Anz, 1926-27, 62: 49-76. Argaue, R., & Mougeot, A. Le ventricule isoie de l'escargot reptesente en realite un myoneurone. Arch. mal. coeur, 1935, 28: 226-35.—Robb, J. S. A historical survey of studies of ventricular structure. Med. Woman J, 1934, 41: 65; 203.— Whitten, M. B. A comparison of the blood supply of the right and left ventricles in childhood. Arch. Int., M, 1930, 45: 46- ---- Abnormity. Cramer, G, & Piischel, E. Linksseitiger sogenannter Aortenventnkel: eine seltene Herzmissbildung; Pathologie und Khmk. Arch. Kinderh, 1939, 117: 45-56.—Gerstmann, H. Ein Fall von Aortenventrikel. Virchows Arch, 1929, 271: 1-13-—Goforth, J. L. Cmque heart anomaly; free fibrous cord passing through 3 Lean chambers to the aorta. J Am M Ass, 1926, 86: 1612— Rapoport, Y. L. [Double heart kpex as a sign of functional independence of ventricles] Med biol J, Leningr., 1929, 5: 22-6. ---- Aneurysm. Brunet, A. *Anevrismes du coeur; etude anatomo-clinique et radioscopique des an6- vrismes pariStaux des ventricules. 70d 8° Par., 1926. y Viers, J. J. *A propos d'un cas d'anevrisme du ventricule gauche diagnostique chez le sujet vivant. 55p. 8? Par., 1937. Ball, D. Aneui \ sm of the heart; the clinical recognition of aneurysm of the left ventricle. Am. Heart J, 1938, 16: 203- 18.—Barnard, W. C. Aneurysm of the left ventricle due to the left coronary artery taking miiiiii from the pulmonary artery J. Path. Bact, Lond, 1938, 47: 345, pl—Bauke, E. E. Ueber den Rontgenbefund bei einem perforationsreifen Herzspit/en- aneurysma. Rontgenpraxis, 1933, 5: 444-8.— Browne, D. (', & McHardy, G. Ventricular aneurysm. South. M. J, 1911, 34; 1257-60.—Caso (Um) de aneurisma da parede do ventriculo direito. An. Fac. med. Recife, 1936, 3: No. 3, 57-9, 3 pi.— Coe, I. S. Left ventricular aneurysm; case report. Memphis M. J, 1939, 14: 196.—East, T. Two cases of aneurysm of left ventricle. Proc. R. Soc. M, Lond, 1933, 26: 518-22.— Eliaser, M, jr, & Konigsberg, J. Electrocardiographic findings in cases of ventricular aneurysm. Arch. Int. M, 1939, 64: 493-504. Also repr.—Excavacao purulenta intra-ventricular; aneurisma micotico. An. Fac. med. Recife, 1934, 1: 74-6, pl.— Fogel, E. I. Aneurysm of the left ventricle follouiim coronary infarct in living patient. J. Am. M. Ass, 1933, 100: 39-42.— Fulton, M. N. Aneurysm of the ventricle of the heart Ibid 1941, 116: 115-22.—Gross, H, & Schwedel, J. B. Lie clinioai course in ventricular aneurysm. N. York State J. M, 1941, 41: 488-91.—Harvier, P, & Carol i. J. Sur un cas d'anevrysme de la pointe du coeur (etude clinique, radiologique et anato- mique) Paris med, 1930, 77: 30-56.—Huyler, W. C. Left ventricular aneurysm; report of case. Am. J. Roentg, 1941, 45: 521.—Iakovlev, T. [Concerning diagnosis of aneurism of cardiac ventricles in living persons] Klin, med, Moskva, 1927, 5: 1023-7.—Jaksch-Wartenhorst, R. Beitrag zur Klinik der Herzventrikelaneurysmen. Deut. Arch, klin Med, 1928, 159: 197-203.—Kahn, M. H. Aneurvsm of the left ventricle. Am. J. M. Sc, 1922, 163: 839-53— LeRoy, G. V, & Roberts, R. C. Systolic gallop rhythm as a sign of aneurysm of the left ventricle; report of a case. Am. Heart J, 1941, 21: 115-9.—Lutembacher, R. Anevrismes du coeur; etude clinique et radiologique des anevrismes ventriculaires. Bull, med. Par, 1926, 41: 139-45.—Mahaim, I. L'aneurisma della punta del cuore e la sua importanza semiologica; la sindrome coronaria anteriore. Rinasc. med, 1930, 7: 214-6, pl—Medlar, E. M, & Middleston, W. S. Aneurysm of the left ventricle. Am. Heart J, 1927-28, 3: 346-55.—Nicoleanu, C, & Popescu, T. [Case of aneurysm of the left ventricle] Rev. san. mil, Bucur, 1929, 28: 397-400.—Peters, J. J. Aneu- rysm of the left ventricle; a report of 2 cases. Am. J. Roentg, 1941, 45: 371-8.—Pletnev, D. D. [Can aneurysm of cardiac ventricles be diagnosed during lifetime?] Vrach. delo, 1926, 9: 1249-58. Also Zschr. klin. Med, 1926, 104: 378-93.—Roubier, C, & Gonnet, J. Volumineux anevrysme de la base du ventri- cule gauche k developpement tetro-auriculaire. Lyon med, 1936, 158: 717-26.—Ruyven, R. L. J. van [Ventricular aneu- rysm] Ned. tschr. geneesk, 1937, 81: 783-7, 2 pl.—Sauerbruch, F. Erfolgreiche operative Beseitigung eines Aneurysma der rechten Herzkammer. Arch. klin. Chir, 1931, 167: 586-8 [Discussion] 133-42.—Schwedel, J. B, & Gross, H. Ven- tricular aneurysm; roentgenographic and postmortem surveys. Am. J. Roentg, 1939, 41: 32-6.—Silva, R. H. Double ani- vrisme du ventricule gauche. Bull. Soc. med. hop. Paris, 1931, 3. ser, 47: 1717-24.—Thiry. Anevrisme partiel de la pointe du coeur; difficulte du diagnostic; mort par syncope. Presse med. beige, 1866-67, 19: 69.—Ushtchantzev, S. A. [Diagnosis during life of aneurysm of the ventricle of the heart] Klin. med, Moskva, 1931, 9: 534-8.—Vaquero, M. Consideraciones acerca de un caso de aneurisma parietal del ventriculo izquierdo. Arch. lat. amer. card, Mex, 1941, 11: 91-101.—Wallis, A. D. Aneurysm of the left ventricle; a case report. Bull. Ayer Clin. Lab, 1934, 3: No. 13, 25-7, pl. ---- Contraction. See also Heart muscle, Contractility. Calandre, L., & Rico, B. Significacion clinica de la sistole ventricular de larga duraci6n. An. Hosp. S. Jose, Madr., 1933-34, 5: 295-304.—Johnson, J. R., & DiPalma, J. R. Relation between initial fiber length and force of contraction in the left ventricle. Am. J. Physiol, 1941, 133: 342.—Sato, M. Die Anordnung der Muskulatur der Herzkammer bei der bystole und der Diastole. Jap. J. M. Sc, 1928-29, 3: Tr., Pharm, 75-95, 3 pl. ---- Disease, and failure. See also Heart-block, Stokes-Adams syndrome. Clerc, A., Bascourret, M., & Levy, R. Valeur de l'eiectro- cardiographie pour le diagnostic et le pronostic de l'insuffisance ventriculaire chronique. Ann. med. Par, 1927, 21: 201-60.— Gallemaerts, V. Troubles ventriculaires et quinidine. C. rend. Congr. fr. med, 1922, 16. sess, 306-12.—Halbron, V. Asystolie et insufhsances ventriculaires. Rev. crit. path. Par, 1930, 1: 497-003— Laubry, C, & Chaperon, R. Etude anatomo- radiologique des cavites cardiaques: applications k l'examen des insufhsances ventriculaires. J. med. fr, 1926, 15: 164-72.— Loeper, M. Insuffisance ventriculaire et ouabaine. In Ther. m1 • (L°rPer, M.) Par, 1933, 6: 37-50.—Rubino, A. II volume del fegato durante la necrosi sperimentale del ventricolo ,flcrcl^ del ventricolo sinistro. Fol. med. Nap, 1937, 23: 1166-77, 5 graph.—Wood, P. Right and left ventricular tailure; a study of circulation time and venous blood pressure. Lancet, Lond., 1936, 2: 15-8. HEART VENTRICLE 403 HEART VENTRICLE ---- Enlargement. See also Heart dilatation; Heart hypertrophy. Canella, F. Sopra una strana dilatazione del ventricolo destro del cuore da cui senza presagi morbosi derivo la morte improwisa. Gior. progr. pat, Venez, 1844, ser. 2, 5: 321-6.— Cossio, P, & Dambrosi, R. Algunas caracterfsticas del agranda- miento del ventriculo izquierdo y del ventriculo derecho. Sem. med, B. Air, 1938, 45: 929-35.—Faleiro, A. Zur elektro- kardiographischen Diagnose der Kammerhypertrophie; die Hypertrophie der linken Kammer. Zschr. klin. Med, 1936- 37, 131: 147-60.—Levene, G, & Lowman, R. M. Roent- genologic demonstration of left ventricular hypertrophy. Am. Heart J, 1940, 19: 401-3.—Martini, T. Las estenosis del ventriculo derecho en las dilataciones excentricas del ventriculo izquierdo: referenda de una observation clinica demostrativa. Rev. Soc. med. int., B. Air, 1926, 2: 381-96, pl—Piorry. Observation d'un cas de degeneration squirreuse de l'aorte, avec hypertrophie du ventricule gauche du cceur et atrophie du ventricule droit. Observ. provenc. sc. med, 1821, 1: 282.— Schwab, R, & Aechter, A. Untersuchungen iiber das Thorax- elektrokardiogramm bei Linkshypertrophie des Herzens. Klin. Wschr, 1936, 15: 1791.—Thompson, W. P., & White, P. D. The commonest cause of hypertrophy of the right ventricle: left ventricular strain and failure. Tr. Ass. Am. Physicians, 1936, 51: 335-40. Also Am. Heart J, 1936, 12: 641-9 — Tobias, J. W, & Gravano, L. Latido toracico universal por dilataci6n hipertrofica del ventriculo izquierdo. Dia med, B. Air, 1935, 7: 1108.—Wassermeyer, H, & Jacobi, J. Ueber die Chemie der Hypertrophie und Atrophie muskularer Organe; Untersuchung des linken Ventrikels nach experimentellen Aortenfehlern. Arch. exp. Path, Lpz, 1930, 155: 70-90 — Wilson, M. G. Clinical radioscopic studies of the heart in children; roentgenologic criteria of cardiac enlargement; size of angle of clearance of left ventricle as criterion of ventricular enlargement. Am. J. Dis. Child, 1934, 47: 750-63. --- Examination. Becart, A. Le systolmetre k mesure totale de A. Walter. Bull. Soc. med. Paris, 1935, 467-72.—Diliberto, U. Sulla prevalenza ventricolare. Cuore & circol, 1936, 20: 157-61.— Farinas, P. L, Aixala, R, [et al] Nuestra interpretaci6n del ventriculo-kimograma. Arch. med. int., Habana, 1935, 1: 96-103.—Galli, W. Quantitative Bestimmung des Rechts- oder Linksiiberwiegens der Herzkammern. Verh. Deut. Ges. Kreislaufforsch, 1934, 7: 274 [Discussion] 279-83—Heck- mann, K. Kymographische Untersuchungen normaler und pathologischer Aktionsformen der Ventrikel. Klin. Wschr, 1935, 14: 700-3.—Kosachevsky, A. A. [On the method of determining the borders between the ventricles] Vest, rentg, 1940. 24: 25-7.—Nemet, G, & Schwedel, J. B. Roentgeno- graphs studies of the right ventricle. Am. Heart J, 1932, 7: 560-73.—Racine, M, & Reboul, H. La ventriculographie cardiaque gauche experimentale. Bull. Soc. med. hop. Paris, 1933, 3. ser, 49: 755-62. ------ Les modifications electro- cardiographiques au cours de la ventriculographie cardiaque gauche experimentale. Presse med, 1933, 41: 950-2.—Ramos, J, & Villaca, C. Exploracao radiol6gica do ventriculo direito. Ann. paul. med. cir., 1939, 37: 407-32.—Reboul, H, & Racine, M. Etude experimentale de la tension arterielle et de la respira- tion au cours des injections intracardiaques de solution de contrast*. Presse med, 1933, 41: 2099-101. --- Fibrillation. See also Heart muscle, Fibrillation. Carstensen, M. I. *Kamrnerflimmern und Sekundenherztod. 18p. 8? Kiel, 1925. Quincke, H. *Das Elektrokardiogramm nach vorausgegangenem Kammerflimmern. 8p. 8°. Kiel, 1925. Beck, C. S, & Mautz, F. R. The control of the heart beat by the surgeon with special reference to ventricular fibrillation occurring during operation. Tr. Am. Surg. Ass, 1937, 55: 45-57.—Bizzozero, R. C. Fibrilaci6n ventricular pasajera registrada durante una crisis sincopal en un sindrome de Stokes- Adams. Rev. argent, card, 1934-35, 1: 371-80.— Bjerlov, H. A case of ventricular fibrillation recovered. Acta med. scand, 1932, 79: Suppl. 50, 121-8.— Blumenthal, B, & Oppenheimer, E. T. Method for the study of ventricular fibrillation. Am. Heart J, 1939, 18: 363-7.—Bovet, D. Antagonisme exerce par les produits antifibrillants du type du diethylaminoethyloxy-2- diphenyle, 1262 Fourneau, sur certaines tachycardies ventricu- laires et etats prefibrillatoires d'origine toxique. Ann. physiol. Par, 1939, 15: 955.—Braun, L, & Samet, B. Studien uber Herzkammer-Flimmern; Herzkammer-Flimmern und Niteo- glyzerin. Wien. klin. Wschr, 1930, 43: 196-8. -----Der Flimmerreflex. Arch. exp. Path, Lpz, 1931, 159: 54769.— Burstein, C. L, & Marangoni, B. A. Protectmg action of procaine against ventricular fibrillation induced by^epinephrine during cyclopropane anesthesia. Proc. Soc. Exp. Biol, N. Y, 1940, 43: 210-2.—Calandre, L, & Martin Rodriguez, F. Muerte subita por fibrilacion ventricular. An. Hosp. S. Jose, Madr, 1933-34, 5: 247-56.—Clerc, A. Les etats prefibrillaires du ventricule en cardiologie clinique. In Contr. M. Sc. (E. Libman Annivers. Vol.) N. Y, 1932, 1: 319-25.—Davis, D, & Sprague, H. B. Ventricular fibrillation, its relation to heart- block; report of a case in which syncopal attacks and death occurred in the course of quinidine therapy. Am. Heart J 1928-29, 4: 559-72.—Demel, R., Jellinek, S, & Kunz, H. Ueber riickbildungsfahiges Herzkammerflimmern im Tier- versuch. Wien. klin. Wschr, 1928, 41: 1426-9.—Dock, W. Transitory ventricular fibrillation as a cause of syncope and its prevention by quinidine sulphate: with case report and discus- sion of diagnostic criteria for ventricular fibrillation. Am. Heart J, 1928-29, 4: 709-14.—Egedy, E, & Kelemen, L. [Effect of quinidin on ventricular flutter] Orv. hetil, 1938, 82: 170, pl.— Fredericq, L. Action de la fibrillation des ventricules sur le rythme des pulsations auriculaires du cceur du chien. Arch. internat. physiol, Liege, 1932, 35: 93-7. Also Bull. Acad. med. Belgique, 1932, 5. ser, 12: 283-8.—Gallavardin, L. La fibrilla- tion ventriculaire. J. med. Lyon, 1927, 8: 453-73. ------& Berard, A. Possibilite d'une fibrillation ventriculaire transi- toire avec accidents syncopaux analogues k ceux du Stokes- Adams et ptecedant la mort subite. Arch. mal. coeur, 1927, 20: 305-8.—Gonzalez Sabathie, L. Hipertiroidismo y trastornos prefibrilatorios ventriculares. In his Temas cardiol, B. Air, 1939, 2: 163-77.—Hooker, D. R. Chemical factors in ventricu- lar fibrillation. Am. J. Physiol, 1930, 92: 639-47. ------ Factors in ventricular fibrillation. Ibid, 1932, 99: 279-84. & Kehar, N. D. Carbohydrate metabolism of the heart during ventricular fibrillation. Ibid, 1933, 105: 246-9. Evidences of an altered tissue state in ventricular fibrillation. Ibid, 1935, 112: 301-6.—Katz, G. I. [Treatment of palpitation and ventricular fibrillation] Odess. med. J, 1928, 3: 312.— Katz, X. N, Lindner, E, & Elek, S. R. Effect of papaverine on ventricular fibrillation. Proc. Inst. M. Chicago, 1940-41, 13: 446.—Kehar, N. D, & McCollum, E. V. Bound water in cardiac muscle in relation to ventricular fibrillation. Am. J. Physiol, 1934-35, 110: 485-7.—Leriche, R, Fontaine, R, & Kunlin, J. Contribution experimentale k l'etude de la fibrilla- tion ventriculaire. C. rend. Soc. biol, 1932, 110: 302-4.— Levine, H. D. Effect of quinidine sulphate in inhibiting ven- tricular fibrillation; an experimental study. Arch. Int. M, 1932, 49: 808-15. Also repr.—Lindner, E, & Katz, L. N. Papaverine hydrochloride and ventricular fibrillation. Am. J. Physiol, 1941, 133: 155; 363.—Lutembacher, R. Fibrillation ventriculaire et systoles ultrafractionnees. Presse med, 1938, 46: 821-4.—Maldonado Allende, I, & Orias, O. Acci6n de la novocaina sobre la fibrilacion ventricular primaria provocada por la oclusion coronaria experimental. Rev. Soc. argent, biol, 1940,16:467-71.—Mautz, F. R. Resuscitation of the heart from ventricular fibrillation, with drugs combined with electric shock. Proc. Soc. Exp. Biol, N. Y, 1937, 36: 634-6—Mey- boom, J. C. C. Ueber den Einfluss von Gravitol und Nitro- glycerin auf das Ventrikelflimmern des isolierten Froschherzens bei erhohter Temperatur. Acta brevia neerl, 1931, 1: 129.— Moisset de Espanes, E. Action de la quinidina y fagarina I- Merck sobre la fibrilaci6n ventricular primaria producida por la oclusion coronaria experimental. Rev. Soc. argent, biol, 1937, 13: 116-20.—Mut, A. Existe en el hombre la fibrilaci6n ventricular? Progr. clin, Madr, 1918, 11: 98-104.—Nagl, F. Plotzlicher Herztod durch Kammerflattern. Deut. Arch. klin. Med, 1935-36, 178: 620-9. ------ Elektrokardiographische Beobachtungen bei einem Falle von passageren Kammer- flattern. Ibid, 630-8.—Nathanson, M. H. Paroxysmal ven- tricular fibrillation. J. Am. M. Ass, 1936, 106: 314.—Otto. H. L. Effect of barium chloride and ouabain upon the onset of ventricular fibrillation. Proc. Soc. Exp. Biol, N. Y, 1928-29, 26: 201.—Parade, G. W. Ueber den plotzlichen Herztod durch Kammerflimmern und seine Bekampfung. Zschr. klin. Med, 1930, 113:641-62.—Prevention (The) of ventricular fibrillation and death from poisoning by benzol and chloroform and from the effect of electric shock. N. England J. M, 1935, 212: 942.— Schlapp, W. Adrenaline and ventricular fibrillation in the decapitated cat. Q. J. Exp. Physiol, Lond, 1933, 23: 335- 42.—Schwartz, S. P. Studies on transient ventricular fibrilla- tion; the prefibrillatory mechanism during established auriculo- ventricular dissociation. Am. J. M. Sc, 1936, 192: 153763. Observations on the clinical and graphic manifestations following the revival of the heart from transient ventricular fibrillation. Ibid, 808-22. ------ Transient ventricular fibrillation: its clinical and graphic manifestations during established auriculoventricular dissociation. Am. Heart J, 1936, 12: 243. ------ A study of the fibrillary process and its development in man. J. Mount Sinai Hosp. N. York, 1941-42, 8: 1005-20. ------& Jezer, A. Observations on the altera- tions in the rhythm of the heart preceding syncopal seizures in a patient with normal sinus rhythm. Am. J. M. Sc, 1934, 187: 469_78. ------ The action of quinine and quinidine on patients with transient ventricular fibrillation. Am. Heart J, 1934, 19: 792-801 —Shen, T. C. R. Benzol-adrenaline cardio-ventncular fibrillation and methods of prevention. Arch, internat. pharm. dyn, Par, 1939, 61: 43-59. ------ & Marri, R. Further studies on cardio-ventricular fibrillation; influence of diethyl- aminoethoxy-2-diphenyl, F. 1262, corynanthine and p - oxy- phenyl-ethanol-methyl-amine, sympatol, on the benzol- adrenaline cardio-ventricular fibrillation in the dog; the role ot the hypertensive action of adrenaline. Ibid, 1940, b4: bO- 78__shen T. C. R, & Simon, M. A. The protecting action of novocaine'upon chloroform-adrenalin ventricular fibrillation. Ibid 1938, 59: 68-74. Also C. rend. Soc. biol, 1938, 127: 1457-9—Sigler, L. H. The fibrillatory phase of transient recurring ventricular fibrillation. Internat. Clin 1939, n. ser. (2) 1' 220-5, 3 pl. ------ Case of ventricular fibrillation following acute coronary occlusion. N. York State J. M, 1940, HEART VENTRICLE 404 HEART VENTRICLE 40: 21S.—Smith. D. C, & Mulder. A. G. The effect of accelera- tor nerve stimulation and of adrenalin on recover \ from ventricu- lar fibrillation in the cat Am. J. Physiol. 1936. 115: 507; 116: 145- Smith, F. H, MrEachcrn. C. G„ tV Hall, G. E. The effect df the intravenous administ lation of quinidine sulfate on the development of ventricular fibrillation following sudden occlusion of the circumflex branch of the left coronary artery; an experimental study. Am. Heart J, 1940, 20: 620-6.— Sulzer, R. L'electrogramme k 2 dimensions du battement et de la fibrillation ventriculaire du cceur du lapin. Arch, internat. physiol, Liege, 1936, 43: 82-9.—Velasco Lombardini, R, & Artucio, H. Contribution al estudio de la fibrilacion ventricular. Prensa med. argent, 1937, 24: 1198-1204.—Vosburgh, B. I.. Three cases of ventricular fibrillation; 1 electric shock and 2 coronary occlusions. N. York State J. M, 1941, 41: 1865-7.— Wegria, R. Ventricular fibrillation. Bull. Am. Ass. Nurse Anestl, 1942, 10: 14-20.—Wiggers, C. J. Fibrilacion ventricu- lar y resuscitaci6n. Bol. Acad. nac. med. B. Aires. 1938, 567- 87. ------ The mechanism and nature of ventricular fibrilla- tion. Am. Heart J, 1940, 20: 399-412. ------ The physio- logic basis for cardiac resuscitation from ventricular fibrillation; method for serial defibrillation. Ibid, 413-22. ------ The ineffectiveness of vagal stimulation on ventricular fibrillation in dogs. Am. J. Physiol, 1941, 133: 634-6. ------& Wegria, R. Ventricular fibrillation due to single, localized induction and condenser shocks applied during the vulnerable phase of ventricular systole. Ibid, 1939-40, 128: 500-5. ------ Attempts at quantitative measurement of fibrillating thresholds for mammalian ventricles. Ibid, 1940, 129: 496. .------ Factors determining the production of ventricular fibrillation by direct currents; with a note on chronaxie. Ibid, 1940-41, 131: 104-28. ------ Quantitative measurement of the fibrillation thresholds of the mammalian ventricles with observations on the effect of procaine. Ibid, 296-308. ------ & Pinera, B. The effects of myocardial ischemia on the fibrilla- tion threshold; the mechanism of spontaneous ventricular fibrillation following coronary occlusion. Ibid, 309-16. ---- Injury [including foreign body] Aviles B, V. M. Herida transfixiante del ventriculo iz- quierdo del coraz6n por arma de fuego. Bol. Soc. cir. Chile, 1934, 12: 11-5.—Bates, W, & Talley, J. E. The electrocardiograms of coronary occlusion following a stab wound in the left ven- tricle. Am. Heart J.. 1929 -30. 5: 232-7— Benedetti-Valentini, F. C'oiit i ibui.o alia eliruigia del cuore; estrazione di un ago dal venincolo sinistro. Cuore & circol, 1929, 13: 266-74.— Kmiliani. P, & Bazzorchi, G. Sulla cicatrizzazione delle feiite del ventricolo sinistro. I'athologica, Genova, 1932, 24: .">.")! 66 — Cellule eiomafhni in una cicatrice del ventri- colo -mi-tro. Ibid, 621.—Fenichel, N. M, Shookhoff, C, & Abramson, D. I. Theoretical considerations regarding the variations of the RS-T segment and subsequent T-wave follow- ing local ventricular trauma. Am. Heart J, 1936, 12: 406- 12.—Henri-Petit, L. Plaie du ventricule gauche par coup de eouteau; suture; guerison. Mem. Acad, chir. Bar, 1940, 66: 593. Also Presse nu'd, 1940, 48: 610.—Korey, H, & Katz, L. N. The electrocardiographic changes produced by injuries of various parts of the ventricles. Am. J. M. Sc, 1934, 188: 387-99.—Larghero Ybarz, P, & Otero, J. P. Herida del corazon, ventriculo izquierdo; operation; curaci6n. Arch. urug. med, 1940, 17: 324-40.—Ludlum, W. D, jr, & Katz, A. Stab wound of heart, right ventricle. Am. J. Surg, 1937, 36: 520-2.—Massias, C. Plaie du ventricule gauche; survie de 6 heures; mort par hemopneumotlorax. Bordeaux chir, 1936, 7: 180-2.—Ortega M, E. A proposito de un caso de herida penetrante toraco-abdominal, herida cavitaria del ventriculo derecho: eardiorrafia. An. Soc. med. quir. Guayas, 1937, 28: 205-12.—Pfeiflfer. Ein Fall von Herzschuss, Herznaht und spontaner Ausstossung des Geschosses aus dem rechten Ven- trikel Med. Korbl. Wiirttemberg, 1928, 98: 154-6.—Porter, W. B, & Bigger, I. A. Nonfatal stab wounds of the ventricles, with electrocardiographic signs of coronary thrombosis and absence of anginal pain. Am. J. M. Sc, 1932, 184: 799-804, 2 pl.—Racz, B. Ueber einen Fall von spontan geheilter Verlet- zung der rechten Herzkammer. Zbl. Chir, 1939, 66: 1276- KO.—Lrrutia, C, & Acuna Zamora, M. Herida cortante trans- fixiante de ambos ventriculos. Bol. Soc. cir. Chile, 1932, 10- 350-5. ---- Intraventricular pressure. Duomarco, J. Nuevos aspectos de la presion intraventricular cardiaca. Arch. urug. med, 1935, 6: 245-60.—Hamilton, W. F, & Brackett, F. S. Dynamic considerations on the relation between aortic and ventricular pressure curves. Am J Physiol, 1935, 112: 130-8.—Moe, G. K, & Visscher, m'. b! The influence of right intraventricular pressure conditions on the distribution and oxygen yield of blood in the coronary circulation of the isolated heait. Ibid, 1939, 126: 588.— Wagner, R. Beziehungen zwischen Atmung und Druck in der rechten Herzkammer. Zschr. Biol, 1937, 98: 248-60. ---- Left ventricle. Antonelli, J. Contribution a l'etude clinique et radiologique du poumon cardiaque au cours de l'insuffisance ventriculaire gauche [Parisl 140p. S? Blois, 1935. Bedford, D. E. Left ventricular failure. Lancet, Lond, 1939. 1: 1303-9, pl—Blondel. Insuficiencia ventricular izquierda. Dia med., B. Air, 1930 31, 3: 463-5.— BringN. L, & Spitzer, A. lane abnoniie Wulstbildung in der linken Hci/ kammer. Virchows Arch, 1928, 267: 9-16. Dumas, \. Manifestation cerebrates de rinsuffisance ventriculaire g.ni. h, J. med. Lyon, 1927, 8: 175-9.- Flaxman, N. Left vein 11, ul:tr failure due to essential b\ pei tension. J. Lab. Clin. M, 1940- 41, 26: 1891-900. Giraud-Costa. E. Contribution k l'etude de la circulation pei iplenque dans rinsuffisance ventriculaire gauche et l'hypcrtonsion arterielle. C. rend. Congr. fr. med (1930) 1931. 21. sess, 370-5.—Hamilton, F. C. Left ventricu- lar failure. Canad. M. Ass. J, 1935, 33: 500 3. -Herrmann, (i. Left ventricular heart failure. Mod. Concepts Card. Dis, 1911, 10: No. 7, 1.—Hoskin, T. J. Left ventricular failure. Post- grad. M. J, Lond, 1938, 14: 100-9. Korns, H. M. Notes on heart failure with report of a case of pure left ventricular failure. Am. Heart J, 1932, 8: 242-8.— Mazeres. Sur le developpement du ventricule gauche en profondeur; nouvelle methode de mesure; l'indice a angle constant. Arch, electr. med, 1930, 38: 481-8.- -Meyer, J. Insuffisance ventriculaire gauche declaneliee par des accidents coliques; souffle forietimi- nel transitoire. Arch. mal. cceur, 1926, 19: 725-7.--Monteiro, E. Insuficiencia ventricular esquerda. Gaz. clin, S. I'aulo 1931, 29: 2-9.—Norman, R. M, & Taylor, A. L. Conge,utai diverticulum of the left ventricle of the heart in a. case of epilnia J. Path. Bact, Lond, 1910, 50: 61-8, 4 pl. Patino Mayer, C, & Mazzei, E. S. Ventricule gauche en uuf v sindromo de Bernheim. Rev. med. lat. amer, B. Air, 1928-29, 14: 1317- 29.—Patron, G. A. Insuficiencia ventricular izquierda; su estudio clinico. Mem. Congr. med. peninsular (1933) 1934, 1. Congr, 55-9.—Plotz, M. Asthmatoid heart failure; a form of left ventricular failure and its differentiation from bronchial asthma bv circulation time and other criteria. Ann. Int. Si 1939-40, 13: 151-60.—Rimbaud, P. L'insuffisance ventiini- laire gauche. Gaz. hop, 1931, 104: 1349-52. Roesler, H, A SoIofT, L. A. Report of a case of left ventricular failure will unusual anatomical changes in tie mvocarilium. Ann Int. M 1935 -36, 9: 477-87. Smith, F. M. Treatment of left, ventricu- lar failure. J. Am. M. Ass, 1937, 109: 646-8.—Stephens, E. Left heart, failure. Med. Hev., N. V, 1936, 144: 270-3 — Tourniquet (The) in left, ventricular failure. Lancet, Lond. 1940, 2: 110.—Traitement (Le) d'urgence des grands accidents d'insuffisance ventriculaire gauche. Rev. gin. clin. ther, 1933, 37: Suppl, 1802.—White, P. D. Weakness and failure of the left ventricle without, failure of the right ventricle; clinical recognition. .1. Am. M. Ass, 1933, 100: 1993-8. Also repr. 93-G00.—Izar, G. Sul trattamento sinto- matico della insufficienza ventricolare destra di media gravitA. Rass. internat. clin. ter, 1937, 18: 247-54.— Kamensky, N. A. Symptomatology of acute deficiency of the right ventricle] Vrach. delo, 1934, 16: 291-4.- Loi, L. Sul reperto anatomo- patologico nella insufficienza acuta del ventricolo destro. Rass. internaz. chn. ter, 1934, 15: 717-26.—Lutembacher, R. L'in- suHisance ventriculaire droite. Bull, med. Par, 1931, 45: —-—_ L'adomdine dans le traitement de l'insuffi- sance ventriculaire droite. Ibid., 1934, 48: 742-5—Men- HEART VENTRICLE 405 HEART VENTRICLE carelli, L. Sopra una rara anomalia del cuore rappresentata da una saccoccia intraventricolare destra in continuity con l'aorta. Pathologica, Genova, 1936, 28: 301-12.—Monteiro, E. Insuficiencia ventricular direita. Gaz. clin, S. Paulo, 1931, 29: 91-9.—Moussoir. Insuffisance ventriculaire droite irte- ductible par adenopathie bilaire et symphyse cardiaque. Bull. Soc. med. h6p. Paris, 1926, 3. ser, 50: 129-32.—Paisseau, G, Oury & Hamburger. Cyanose et insuffisance ventriculaire droite. Ibid, 1925, 3. ser, 49: 1027-39.—Ponde, A. Stenosi del ventricolo destro per deviamento del setto. Cuore & circol, 1937, 21: 249-60.—Renzi, S. de. Sullo scompenso acuto ventricolare destro. Rass. fisiopat, 1937, 9: 338-52.—Schiassi, F. Di una forma particolare di scompenso cronico di circolo per insufficienza del ventricolo destro. Bull sc. med, Bologna, 1938, 110: 9-16. Also In Libro de oro M. R. Castex, B. Air, 1939, 3: 1221-6.—Taussig, H. B. Two cases of congenital mal. formation of the heart due to defective development of the right ventricle; clinical and pathological findings. J. Techn. Meth, Toronto, 1936, 16: 66.—Uhlenbruck, P. Beobachtungen zur rechtsventrikuliiren Herzinsuffizienz. Deut. Arch. klin. Med, 1929,163:220—44. ------ Das Versagen des rechten Herzens. Zbl. inn. Med, 1932, 53: 951-71.—Weinberg, E. Ueber die innere Oberflache der rechten Kammer des Herzens. Anat, Anz, 1939, 88: 381-7. --- Right ventricle: Stenosis [Bernheim's syndrome] Martini, T., & Joselevich, M. La estenosis dextroventricular (sindrome de Bernheim) 127p. 8? B. Air., 1931. Alexandresco-Dersca, C, & Focsa, P. Trois cas de syn- drome de Bernheim (asystolie produite par le stenose du ventri- cule droit causee par la deviation de la cloison interventriculaire au cours de l'hypertrophie du ventricule gauche) insuffisance cardiaque par syndrome de Bernheim. Presse med, 1931, 39: 1437.—Bullrich, R. A. La asistolia derecha. Rev. med. lat. amer, B. Air, 1927, 12: 31-8. ------■ El sindrome de Bernheim; su diagn6stico clinico y electrocardiografico. Ibid, 1928, 13: 1839-48.—Carrega Casaffousth, C. F., & Suberviola, J. Sindrome de Bernheim; su frecuencia. Prensa med. argent, 1936, 23: 193-201.—Cieza Rodriguez, L. F. Sindrome de Bernheim. Rev. As. med. argent, 1940, 54: 872-4.—Cobo, D. Un caso clinico de sindrome de Bernheim. Rev. m6d. veracruz, 1935, 15: 1533-7.—Copani, A. El sindrome de Bernheim; asistolia por estenosis del ventriculo derecho por desviacion del tabique ventricular en las hipertrofias izquierdas. Dia med, B. Air, 1938, 10: 256-61.—Duclos, F. Un caso de asistolia de Bernheim con examen necropsico (posibilidad de diagnostico en vida) Med. ibera, 1934, 28: 736.—Martini, T, & Joselevich. M. Asistolia en una mitral, con estenosis manifiesta del ventriculo derecho (las seudoasistolias derechas de los mitrales) Sem. med, B. Air, 1927, 34: pt 2, 11-5. ----- Sobre la patogenia del estasis circulatorio en el sindrome de Bernheim. Ibid, 1930, 37: pt 2, 15-22. ------ Las primeras manifestaciones de la estenosis dextro-ventricular. Dfa med, B. Air, 1931-32, 4: 47.—Mazzei, E. S. La asistolia derecha en el concepto de Laubry. Ibid, 1929-30, 2: 845. ----- La asistolia derecha y el sindromo de Bernheim. Rev. m6d. lat. amer, B. Air, 1929-30, 15: 685-98. Also Rev. med. Par, 1931, 48: 493-504.—Olmer, J, Buisson [et al] Considerations sur le syndrome de Bernheim. Marseille med, 1933, 70: 615-27.—Patino Mayer, C, & Mazzei, E. S. Asis- tolia: sindromo de asistolia por estenosis de cavidad ventricular derecha consecutiva a desviacion del tabique interventricular, sindromo de Bernheim. Rev. med. lat. amer, B. Air, 1928, 13: 2015-44.—Perez de los Reyes, R. El sindrome de Bern- heim. Vida nueva, Habana, 1930, 26: 549-67, 6 pl—Podesta, E. E. La stenosi destroventricolare (sindrome di Bernheim) Cuore & circol, 1936, 20: 290-316.—Ponde, A. Syndrome de Bernheim. Brasil med, 1937, 51: 236-43. --- Rupture. See also Heart muscle, Rupture. Brandi, B. Spontanruptur der tuberkulosen rechten Herz- wand; embolischer Verschluss der A. pulmonalis durch Tampon- streifen. Deut. Zschr. Chir, 1931, 231: 255-61.—Brown, C. C. Rupture of the cardiac ventricle. S. Afr. M. J, 1934, 8: 254 — Hodge, B. L. Spontaneous rupture of the right ventricle of the heart. Brit. M. J, 1927, 1: 1096.—Wood, J. P. Rupture of the left ventricle of the heart. Med. Bull. Veterans Admin, 1940-41, 17: 306. --- Septum. See also Heart chambers, Septum. Drechsel, J. Zur Architektur der Herzkammer wande. Zschr. ges. Anat, 1. Abt, 1928, 87: 29-44.—Gassendi, P. A nice observation of the perviousness of the septum of the heart, transl. by G. K. Tallmadge. In Cardiac Classics (Wil- lius, F. A.) S. Louis, 1941, 84.—Odgers, P. N. B. The develop- ment of the pars membranacea septi in the human heart. J. Anat, Lond, 1937-38, 72: 247-59, 2 pl—Robb, J. S. The distribution of the Purkinje material in the septum of the beef heart. Am. J. Physiol, 1939, 126: 608. Septum: Abnormity. See also Heart chambers, Septum: Cor bi- atriatum triloculare. Kaewel, E. V. H. . *Endocardtaschen auf dem Septum ventriculorum [Breslaul p.431-65 8° Jena, 1928. Also Beitr. path. Anat, 1928, 79: Aellig, A. Das Foramen interventriculare persistens cordis bei den Haustieren. Schweiz. Arch. Tierh, 1930 72- 509- 1931, 73: 10.—Halpert, B, & Tennant, R. Anomalies of the interventricular septum and pulmonary orifice; report of 2 cases. Am. J. Path, 1934, 10: 375-82, pl—Montanini, N. Di un raro meccanismo di completa riparazione in caso di difetto del setto interventricolare. Med. ital, 1932, 13: 449-54.—Robson, G. M. Congenital heart disease; a persistent ostium atrioventriculare commune with septal defects in a Mongolian idiot. Am. J. Path, 1931, 7: 229-36, 2 pl— Taussig, H. B. A single ventricle with a diminutive outlet chamber. J. Techn. Meth, Toronto, 1939, 19: 120-8. ---- Septum: Aneurysm. Bock, T. *Das Aneurysma der Pars mem- branacea septi ventriculorum cordis. 29p. 8? Munch., 1935. Cannell, D. E. Congenital aneurysm of the intraventricular septum. Am. J. Path, 1930, 6: 477-84, pl.—Guccione, F. Aneurisma disseccante del setto interventricolare (pars mem- branacea) Arch, biol, Genova, 1926, 3: No. 6, 55-67.— Lev, M. A congenital aneurysm of the membranous part of the interventricular septum. Tr. Chicago Path. Soc, 1932-36, 14: 309. ------ & Saphir, O. Congenital aneurysm of the membranous septum. Arch. Path, Chic, 1938, 25: 819-37.— Massig, E. Congenital aneurysm of the interventricular sep- tum. Bull. Internat. Ass. M. Mus, Montreal, 1934, No. 13, 95-100. Also repr.—Mencarelli, L. Sopra un caso di aneurisma congenito del setto membranaceo. Riforma med, 1929, 45: 598-600. ------ Ancora sull'aneurisma o meglio diverticolo del setto membranaceo. Cuore & circol, 1934, 18: 429-34.— Pouche, A. Sopra un caso di aneurisma del setto interventri- colare con perforazione nei ventricolo destro e stenosi della polmonare. Med. ital, 1933, 14: 90-103.— Rae, V. Congenital aneurysm of interventricular septum complicated by subaortic stenosis and other anomalies. J. Techn. Meth, Toronto, 1936, No. 15, 136-9.—Rijssel, van [Aneurysm of septum membranaceum ventriculorum cordis] Ned. tschr. geneesk, 1927, 71: pt 2, 477-9.—Vedrani, A. Gli errori celebri della medicina: la perforazione del setto mediano del cuore. Illust. med. ital, 1924, 6: 75; 108.—Wilson, C. P. Mycotic aneurysm involving the intraventricular septum; report of 3 cases. Am. Heart J, 1925-26, 1: 703-6. Also repr. ---- Septum: Defect, acquired. Huber, H. *Ueber erworbene Defekte der Herzkammerscheidewand [Wurzburg] lip. 8? Lpz., 1935. Also Zschr. Kreislaufforsch, 1935, 27: 825-30. Castellanos, A. Sobre el diagn6stico angio-cardiografico de la comunicacion inter-ventricular. Arch. lat. amer. card, Mex, 1938, 8: 1-18— Gross, H, & Schwartz, S. P. A case of acquired interventricular septal defect associated with long- standing congestive heart failure. Am. Heart J, 1936, 11: 626-30.—Husten. Perforierender Defekt des Septum ventri- culorum auf traumatischer Grundlage. Verh. Deut. path. Ges, 1926, 21: 249-59. Also Zbl. allg. Path, 1926, 37: 543 — Moolten, S. E. Prolonged survival after perforation of the infarcted interventricular septum in coronary arterial disease. Arch. Int. M, 1942, 69: 108-16.—Stanley, D. F. Acquired interventricular septum defect, report of a case. Am. Heart J, 1937, 14: 240-3.—Tesseraux, H. Zur Kenntnis der Defekte der Herzkammerscheidewand. Virchows Arch, 1933, 289: 412-29.—Vyshegorodtseva, V. D. [Case report of a defect of the intra-ventricular septum of the heart of traumatic origin] Klin, med, Moskva, 1941, 19: 119-22. ---- Septum: Defect, congenital [Roger's dis- ease] Astesiano, G. ^Contribution a l'etude de la maladie de Roger chez l'enfant a, propos de 19 observations personnelles. 77p. 2512(>m. Mar- seille, 1934. Brandenburg, G. E. *Le souffle diastolique dans la maladie de Roger. 41p. 8? Par., 1934. Brunninger, M. G. *Kongenitale Kammer- scheidewanddefekte mit konsekutiver Pulmona- liserweiterung [Bern] 72p. 8? Berl., L. Schumacher, 1901. HEART VENTRICLE 406 HEART VENTRICLE Schankath, T. *Ueber einen klinisch vollig atypischen Fall von kongenitalem Ventrikel- septumdefekt mit paradoxer Hirnembolie. 24p. 8? Kiel, 1926. Apert, E, & Cambessfedes. Malformations cardiaques (maladie de Roger) chez une ntere et 2 de ses enfants. Bull. Soc. pediat. Paris. 1930, 28: 340-3—Arkussky. I. Das Ront- genbild der angeborenen Stenose der Lunaenarterie bei eleich- zeitiger Existenz einps Defekts der Kammerscheidewand. Fortsch. Rontgenstrahl, 1930, 41: 617-26.—Brusa, P. Con: siderazioni sul reperto di soffio cardiaco simulante il morbo di Roger nei lattante, in assenza del corrispondente reperto anatomico. Lattante, 1935, 6: 159-67.—Bullrich, R. A, & Del Castillo, E. B. Enfermedad de Roger y dextrocardia con transposici6n de vlsceras. Sem. med, B. Air, 1926. 33: 23-5.—Cardelle, G, Sanchez Santiago, B, 1933i4: ---- atmospheric. See Air, Moisture and temperature; Climate: Meteorology. ---- atomic. See Heat, specific. ---- Biological effect. See also Diathermy, Effects, &c. For effects upon the heat metabolism of the animal body see under Heat [animal]. For effects upon specific organs, functions, and substances see names of organs, functions, and substances as Blood pressure, Variations: External factors; Brain. Effect of physical agents, &c. Belehradek, J. Temperature and living matter. 277p. 8? Berl., 1935. Brunbauer, P. *Der Einfluss der Temperatur auf das Leben der Tagfelter [Univ. Jena] 115p. 8? Munch., 1883. Mehling, L. *Vergleichende plethysmo- graphische Untersuchungen bei Warme- und Kaltereizen [Frankfurt] 24p. 22cm. Lenge- rich, 1938. Taeger [A. T.] H. *Der Wirkbereich von Temperaturreizen. p.262-84. 8? BerL. 1933. Amar, J. Le coefficient hydrothermique chez les homeo- thermes. C. rend. Acad, sc, 1932, 194: 484. ------ Le coefficient de partage hydrothermique. Ibid, 1382-5.— Barcroft, J, & Izquierdo, J. J. The effect of temperature on the frequency of heart and respiration in the guinea-pig and cat. J. Physiol, Lond, 1931, 71: 364-72.—Bazett, H. C. Physio- logical responses to heat. Physiol. Rev, 1927, 7: 531-99. ------ The effect of temperature on the skin; a review. J. Invest. Derm, 1938, 1: 413-25. ------ Scott, J. C. [et al] Effect of temperature changes on the circulation. Am. J. Physiol, 1935, 113: 9.—Belehfadek, J. Sur la formule generale exprimant Taction de la temperature sur les processus biologi- ques. C. rend. Soc. biol, 1926, 95: 1449-52. ------ Sur la signification des coefficients de temperature. Protoplasma, Lpz, 1929, 7: 232-55. ------ La vie et la temperature. Bruxelles med, 1939-40, 20: Spec. No, 51.—Bock, A. V, & Dill, D. B. A resume of some physiological reactions to high external temperature. N. England J. M, 1933, 209: 442-4.— Bodenheimer, F. S. Observations on rodents in Herter's temperature gradient. Physiol. Zool, 1941, 14: 186-92.— Brody, S. Temperature factors in animal production. In Temperature (Am. Inst. Physics) N. Y, 1941, 462-73 — Buchanan, J. W. Developmental rate and alternating tempera- tures. J. Exp. Zool, 1940, 83: 235-48.—Buratti, P. Sulle variazioni locali della pressione arteriosa per effetto della temperatura. Arch. sc. biol, Bologna, 1929-30, 14: 182-9 — Cameron, A. T. Temperature and life and death. Tr. R. Soc. Canada, 1930, 3. ser, 24: Sect. Biol, 53-93.—Carlson, A. J. Physiological effects of heat. Arch. Phys. Ther, 1928, 9: 343-6.—Cook, S. F. The effect of sudden changes of tempera- ture on protoplasmic streaming. J. Gen. Physiol, 1928-29, 12: 793-803.—Dognon, A, & Tsang, J. L. influence de la temperature dans Taction des rayons secondaires corpusculaires sur les bacteries. C. rend. Soc. biol, 1930, 104: 254-6.— Donnan, F. G. Concerning the applicability of thermody- namics to the phenomena of life. J. Gen. Physiol. (J. Loeb Mem. Vol.) 1927, 8: 685-8. Also repr.—Drinker, C. K. The effects of heat and humidity upon the human body. In Environ- ment &c. (Harvard Univ.) Bost, 1937, 68-81.—Effects of different temperatures on health and efficiency. In Handb. Lab. Statist. (Parker, F. E.) Wash, 1936, 358-61.—Eltsina, N. V. [Temperature coefficient in biology] Usp. sovrem. biol, 1940, 12: 52-64.—Ephrussi, B. Remarques sur les coefficients de temperature des processus biologiques. Arch. anat. micr. Par, 1929, 25: Spec. No, 231-5.—Feldman, J., & Gellhorn, E. The influence of variations in environmental temperature and of fever on the vago-insulin and sympathetico-adrenal systems. Am. J. Physiol, 1941, 133: 273.—Fosi, V. Prime osservazioni sull'influenza della temperatura sulla neotenia parziale degli anfibi anuri. Monit. zool. ital, 1934, 45: 8-12.—Galtsoff, P. S. The effect of temperature on the mechanical activity of the gills of the oyster (Ostrea virginica Gm.) J. Gen. Physiol, 1927-28, 11: 415-31.—Glekel, M. S. [Significance of the cardiac functional test during work in conditions of over- heating] Tr. Acad. mil. med. Kiroff, 1935, 4: 155-61 — Gottlieb, J. S. The effect of changes in the environmental temperature on the blood pressure and pulse rate in normal men. Am. J. Physiol, 1935, 113: 181-5.—Harnly, M. H. The temperature responses of flies with the deficiency vestigial- HEAT 408 HEAT depilate in Drosophila melanogaster. Genetics, 1940, 25: 521-33.—Hecht, S. An analysis of the relation between the temperature and the duration of a biological process. Proc. Nat. Acad. Sc. U. S, 1919, 5: 140-8— Herter. K. Tempera- turversuche mit Egeln. Zschr. vergl. Physiol, 1929, 10: 2-IS 71.— Hintze, K. Versuche uber den Einfluss von Temperature und leuchtigkeit im geschlossenen Raum auf den menschlichen Organismus. Zschr. Hyg, 1915, 80: 171 -83.— Jacobs, M. H. The complex nature of the effects of temperature on the rates of certain biological processes. Am. Natur, 1928, 72: 289- 97.—Janisch, E, & Maercks, H. Ueber die Bercchnung der Kettenlinie als Ausdriick fiir die Temperaturabhangigkeit von Lebenserscheinuugen. Arb. Biol. Reichsanst, 1932-33, 20: 259-68.—Jones, P. H, jr. Effects of high environmental temperature on the human body. N. Orleans M. & S. J. 1940- 41, 93: 288-93.—Kanno, H. Influence of application of cold and heat upon the blood pressure and heart beat of non- fastened, non-anaesthetized rabbits. Jap. J. M. Sc, 1939-40, 6: Proc. Biophysics, 123.—Kligler, I. J, & Geiger, A. Relation of temperature to nutrition and resistance. Proc. Soc. Exp. Biol, N. Y, 1929-30, 27: 793-5.—Knight, F. C. E. Die Entwicklung von Triton alpestris bei verschiedenen Tempera- turen, mit Normentafel Arch. Entwmech, 1937-38, 137: 461-73.—Kozhanchikov, I. W. Zur Frage nach dem Tempera- turoptimum des Lebens; iiber die Temperaturabhangigkeit einzelner physiologischer Prozesse und ihre Beziehung auf das Lebensoptimum des Organismus. Zschr. angew. Entom, 1933-34, 20: 590-610. ------ Ueber die Beziehung der Ent- wicklungsgeschwiiidigkeit zum vitalen Optimum. Ibid, 1936, 22: 452-62.—Lherisson, C. De la valeur relative des coeffi- cients theriiiicpies en biologie. Protoplasma, Lpz, 1938, 31: 535-9.—Mancuso, B. SulTazione dell'insolazione e delle altc temperature su varie specie di animali. Ann. igiene, 1937, 47: 238-43.—Matisse, G. Action de la chaleur et du froid sur l'activite mot rice et la sensibilite de quelques invertebres marins. Bull Inst. gen. psychol, Par, 1910, 10: 247-69.— Moiseev, S. G. [Arterial sounds heard determining blood pressureby Korotkov's methodinlocal effects of heat on various parts of the body| Klin, med, Moskva, 1936, 14: 1362-7 — Nakanishi. S. Leber den Einfluss der Temperatur auf das Aktionspotential. J. Chosen M. Ass, 1937, 27: 23—Navez, A. E. A propos de coefficients de temperature en biologie. Protoplasma, Lpz, 1931, 12: 86-11 l.—Neel, J. V. The interrelations of temperature, body size, and character expres- sion in Drosophila melanogaster. Genetics, 1940, 25: 225-50.— Osborne, S. L. The physiology of heat. Physiother. Rev, 1939, 19: 59-62.—Ostow, M. Thermodynamics in medicine. Med. Bull, N. Y, 1938-39, 4: 143-6.—Pemberton, R. A summary of the effects of external heat upon the human body. Am. J. M. Sc, 1925, 169: 485-9. ------ The physiological effect of external heat upon the human body. Ann. Clin. M, 1926 -27, 5: 763-71. ------ The influence and therapeutic use of heat ; physiologic effects of heat. J. Am. M. Ass, 1935, 105: 275-80.—Pike, F. H. The thermodynamic probability of living organisms. Anat. Rec, 1941, 81: Suppl, 114 (Abstr.)— Plank. R. Die Temperaturabhangigkeit vitaler Prozesse. Arch. ges. Physiol, 1937, 239: 74-80— Przibram, H. Tem- peraturquotienten fur Lebenserscheinungen der Sphodromantis bioculata Burm. (zugleich: Aufzucht der Gottesanbeterinnen) Arch. Entwmech, 1917, 43: 28-36.—Raffy, A. Reaction des blattes aux variations de temperature. C. rend. Soc. biol, 1930, 104: 657.—Rahn, O. Temperature and life. In Tem- perature (Am. Inst. Physics) N. Y, 1941, 409-19.—Reese, H. H, & Masten, M. G. The effects of heat. Wisconsin M. J, 1931, 30: 630-2.—Rogers, C. G, & Lewis, E. M. The tempera- ture coefficient of the rate of contraction of the dorsal blood- vessel of the earthworm. Biol Bull, 1914, 27: 269-74.— Roskam, J. Quelques considerations concernant Taction des variations de la temperature sur le tonus vesical et, plus generalement, sur le tonus de la mature vivante. Arch internat. physiol, Liege, 1914-20, 15: 473-5.—Ryan, F. J. Temperature change and the subsequent rate of develop- ment. J. Exp. Zool, 1941, 88: 25-54.—Sizer, I. W. Stimula- tion of Fundulus by oxalic and malonic acids and breathing rhythm as functions of temperature. J. Gen. Phvsiol, 1935- 36, 19: 693-714. Also repr.—Steiner, G. Der Einfluss der Salzkonzentration auf die Temperaturabhangigkeit verschie- dener Lebensvorgiinge. Zschr. vergl. Physiol, 1934, 21: 666- 79.—Stier, T. J. B, A: Wolf, E. On temperature characteristics for different processes in the same organism. J. Gen. Phvsiol 1932, 16: 367-74. Also repr.—Talbott, J. H, Edwards, H. f! [et al] Physiological responses to high environmental tempera- ture. Am. J. Trop. M, 1933, 13: 381-97.—Van Amstel, J, & \an Iterson, G, jr. Over het temperatuuroptimum van physiologische processen. Versl. Akad. wet. Naturh, Amst l'.UO, 19: 106; 534, 2 pl—Winslow, C. E. A, Herrington, L. V.', & Gagge, A. P. Physiological reactions of the human body to varying environmental temperatures. Am. J. Physiol, 1937, 120: 1-22.—Wolf, E. Temperature characteristics for pulsa- tion frequency in Gonionemus. J. Gen. Physiol, 1927-28, 11: 547-62. Also repr. ---- Biological effect: Chemical and serological changes. See also Adsorption; Diffusion; Dissociation; Ionization; Metabolism, &c; and other physico- chemical and serological subject headings. Scharer, A. *Unt(M'suchungen iiber Srrum- veranderungen bei positiver Thermotherapie [Zurich] p.97 112. S'." Boil., 192(1 Also Zschr. ges. phys. Ther, 1026, 31: Banyai, G. [Effect of thermotherapv on the plasma protein fractions] Gyogyaszat, 1933, 73: 775 8.—Bazett, H. C, & Sribyatta, L. The effect of local changes in temperature on gas tensions in the tissues. Am. J. Physiol, 1928, 86: 565-77.— Blumberg, H. Wasserstoff-Ionenkonzentration und Gesamt- aziditat des Urins nach warmen und heissen physikalischen Prozeduren. Zschr. wiss. Baderk, 1928 29, 3: 106-12.— Corteggiani, E, Gautrelet, J. [et al] Sur Texistence d'un complexe libelant Tacetylcholine dans les centres nerveux sous l'influence de la chaleur. C. rend. Sue. biol, 1936, 123: 667.— Crema, C. II comportamento del fenomeno d'ostacolo nelle orine degli operai addetti alia lavorazione nella camera calda. Rass. med. lavoro indust, 1935, 6: 4-11-9. Ernstrom, E. Ueber den Temperaturkoeffizienten der Starkespaltung und die Thermostabilitat der Malzann lase und des I'tvalins Zschr. physiol. Chem, 1922, 119: 190-263. Ferrigno, R. Sulla accelerazione termica dei processi deidrogenativi. Riv. pat. sper, 1928, 3: 3-7.—Formicola, P. L'influenza delle modificazioni della temperatura del corpo sulla glicemia e sulla riserva alcalina; diminuzione della temperatura. Mor- gagni, 1934, 76: 519; 819.—Hefter, U. M, & Udelovich, R. Y. [Biochemical changes in the organism during work in high temperature] Klin, med, Moskva, 1931, 9: 42-4.—Hopf, H. S. The physiological action of abnormally high temperatures on poikilothermic animals; some changes occurring in the phos- phorus distribution of the haemolymph of insects under the influence of abnormally high temperature. Biochem. J, Lond, 1940, 34: 1396-403.—Kayser, C. Effet des variations de la temperature ambiante sur le quotient respiratoire et la reserve alcaline de la grenouille. C. rend. Soc. biol, 1936, 123: 818-20.—Keeley, J. L., Gibson, J. G, & Pijoan, M. The effect of thermal trauma on blood volume, serum protein, and certain blood electrolytes; an experimental study of the effect of burns. Surgery, 1939, 5: 872-93.—Lehmann, G, & Szakall, A. Der Chlorstoffwechsel bei Hitzearbeit. Arbeitsphysiologie, 1935-37, 9: 653-77.—Matusis, I. I. [Effect of ascorbic acid on the protein content of blood in overheating] J. Physiol. USSR, 1941, 30: 602-7.—Nordefeldt, E. Ueber den Tem- peraturkoeffizienten der H202-Spaltung durch Fettkatalase. Biochem. Zschr, 1920, 109: 26-35.—Palmieri, V. M. Sero- logische Untersuchungen an Arbeitern in uberhitzten Raumen. Deut. Zschr. gerichtl. Med, 1926, 7: 547-60. ------ Ricerche sierologiche sugli operai in ambienti soprariscaldati. Gior. batt. immun, 1926, 1: 113-29.—Perez, M. Ricerche speri- mentali sul comportamento di alcuni elettroliti del sangue nelle esioni da alte temperature e da agenti chimici. Arch, ital chir, 1939, 56: 116-27.—Riddle, O, Smith, G. C, & Benedict, F. G. Seasonal and temperature factors and their determina- ion in pigeons of percentage metabolism change per degree of temperature change. Am. J. Physiol, 1934, 107: 333-42. Also repr.—Scaflidi, V. Ricerche sulle modificazioni del meta- bolismo per variazioni della temperatura locale dei tessuti; il contenuto in acqua e in sali della cute e dei muscoli in seguito a riscaldamento locale. 'Riv. pat. sper, 1928, 3: 382-9.— Terroine, E. F, & Sziics, F. Influence de la temperature sur le taux des protides et des corps puriques chez les microorganismes, Ann. physiol. Par, 1930, 6: 150-6. ---- Biological effect: Histological changes. See also Heat, Pathology; Heatstroke; also names of organs and tissues affected. Avellone, L. Influenza della temperatura sulla velocity di disintegrazione dei tessuti. Riv. pat. sper, 1926, 1: 76-80 ^ Belehradek, J, & Melichar, J. L'action differente des t' peratures eievees et des temperatures normales sur la su!,"?" de la cellule vegetale (Helodea canadensis Rich) Biol ™e Vvien, 1930 6: 109-24.-Brancato, F. Ricerche ematol0S ed immunitarie sui fuoclnsti. Arm. med. nav Roma 1098 34: pt 2, 187-97 -Caillet, O. R, & Simomta? J.' P. Rented exposure to high temperature; effect on lymphoid tissue and on leukocyte count. Arch. Path, Chic 1929 8-699 7 oeratur auf Leber A" ,Der E'nAuss hoherer Aussentcm- S w wn i llz ^r Hausmaus. Verh. Anat Ges P. L & Moni.rnmprv V a At • 10bl-3.—McLain, workmen TZg^^vJSS™ ?"$* blood of S M^entcheif ^iMno!ha,tr "V^^ Bhltve^Uu^ „' geTexp16^? ife, ^wESf-^K V%t ^ HEAT 409 HEAT The reversible heat shortening of elastic connective tissue, and an examination of the possible effects of certain factors on the heat shortening of connective tissues. Am. J. Physiol, 1933, 106: 125-33.—Sribyatta, H. C, & Bazett, H. C. The effect of local changes in temperature on blood from the hand veins. Ibid, 1928, 86: 578-86.—Sugawara, S. Experimental study of the influence of muscular labour in hot atmosphere on blood. Bull. Nav. M. Ass. Tokyo, 1936, 25: 66.—Weimann, W. Histologische Befunde an den inneren Organen nach Einwirkung hoher Temperaturen. Virchows Arch, 1927, 264: 1-10. ■--- Conduction, and conductor. See also subheading Transmission; also Heat- ing. Botjssinesq, J. Etude sur la propagation de la chaleur dans les milieux homogenes [Faculty des Sciences] 61p. 8? Par., 1867. Lubin, G, & Bullowa, J. G. M. A thermal conductivity recorder for oxygen and carbon dioxide for clinical atmospheric control. Proc. Soc. Exp. Biol, N. Y, 1929-30, 27: 568 — Osborn, R. H. The thermal conductivities of, and Thompson effect in, tungsten and molybdenum at incandescent tempera- tures. Abstr. Theses Univ. Pittsburgh, 1938, 14: 212-8.— Vernotte, P. Comment aborder les problemes du propagation de la chaleur, avec frontieres fixes, lorsque les proprietes thermiques du milieu dependent de la temperature. C. rend. Acad, sc, 1934, 198: 1584-6. --- Conservation, and regulation. See also Heating; Thermostat. Cool ohms. Rev. Sc. Instrum, 1942, 13: 44.—Dalzell, J. R, & Hubbard, C. L. Insulation. In their Air Condit, Chic, 1939, 67— Raisch, E, & Schropp, K. Prufung der Temperaturbestiiiidigkeit von Wiirmeschutzmitteln, insbe- sondere von gebrannten Kieselgursteinen. Gesundh. Inge- nieur, 1931, 54: 581-5.—Rowley, F. B. Insulating value of bright metallic surfaces. Tr. Am. Soc. Heat. Ventil Engin, 1934, 40: 413-26.—V, S. Glaswolle als Wiirmeschutz. Um- schau, 1929, 33: 856-8.—Vs cold and wet. Rev. Sc. Instrum, 1941, 12: 619. --- Disinfection by. See also Food, Conservation; Steam; Steriliza- tion. Ferreira Bairrao Ruivo, M. *Algumas palavras sobre a desinfeccao pelo calor. 75p. 8? Lisb., 1881. Good, E. *Weitere Untersuchungen zur Desinfektion unter Bedingungen der Praxis mit besonderer Berucksichtigung der Temperatur- vvirkung [Zurich] 53p. 8? Mels, 1921. Patzschke, W. *Ueber die Widerstands- fahigkeit von Bakterien gegeniiber hohen Tem- peraturen und das Lobecksche Biorisierverfahren. 32p. 8? Lpz., 1916. Also Zschr. Hyg, 1916, 81: 227-56. Barrett, R. E. A portable steam disinfestor. East Afr. M. J, 1937-38, 14: 132-4.—Bleyer, L. Der Nachweis der Abtotung durch Kultur und Tierversuch bei mit Hitze be- handelten Bakterien. Zschr. Hyg, 1923, 99: 98-100.— Carbonell, M. V. Experiencias de desinfection por medio del aire caliente agitado. Rev. As. med. argent, 1920, 33: Sect. Soc. hig, 1-6.—Delepine, S. Disinfection by heat. Med. Press & Circ, Lond, 1916, 102: 8.—Fleischer, L, & Amster, S. Ueber den Einfluss des Mediums auf die Resistenz der Bak- terien; Desinfektionsversuche mit Hitze. Zschr. Hyg, 1923, 99: 209-20.—Lange, B, & Keschischian, K. H. Beitrage zur Methodik der Desinfektionsmittelprufung; die Schadigung pathogener Keime durch Erhitzung, gemessen an ihrer Fort- pflanzungsenergie in kunstlicher Kultur und ihrer Virulenz. Ibid, 101: 88-103.—Schmitt, H. Kritische Zusammenfassung der Arbeiten uber Hitzedesinfektion aus den Jahren 1914 mit 1919. Erg. Hyg. Bakt, 1920, 4: 310-28.—Weyde, A. J. van der [Disinfection of merchandize by high temperature in 1830] Ned. tschr. geneesk, 1931, 75: pt 4, 5902-4. --- Hygiene, and comfort. See also subheading Resistance [and toler- ance]; also Summer; Tropics; Work, Physiology. Bedford, T. The warmth factor in comfort at work; a physiological study of heating and ventilation. llOp. 8? Lond., 1936. Xoack, W. *Ueber die Wirkung heissen Klimas auf den arbeitenden Menschen und die bisher dafiir benutzten Messmethoden. 21p. 8? Berl., 1932. Also Zbl. ges. Hyg, 1932, 28: Arefieva, T. D., Benediktova, E. I. [et al ] . regime bei der Arbeit in einer Werkstatt mit hoher Tempera- tur] J. Physiol. USSR, 1934, 17: 361-76.-Blinova, AM, Sevenn, S. E, & Lobova, Z. T. [Zur Frage uber die Aus- arbeitung einer rationellen Nahrungsration fiir Arbeiter der Betnebe mit hoher Temperatur] Ibid, 1935, 18: 869-77 — Bottner, H, & Schlegel, B. Experimental investigations on prophylaxis of heat disorders. J. Am. M. Ass 1942 118- 413 (AbstrO—Crowden, G. P. Insulation against heat in the Tropics. Tr. R. Soc. Trop. M. Hyg, Lond, 1935-36, 29: 1—Delebrassmne, F. La protection thermique des apparte- ments. Techn. san. mun. Par, 1933, 28: 339-41.—Ferderber, M. B, & Houghten, F. C. Effective temperature scale; a measure of human comfort in environmental temperature. J. Am. M Ass, 1941, 116: 474-7.—Gautrelet, J. La lutte contre la chaleur. In Traite physiol. norm. path. (Roger G. H, & Bmet, L.) Par, 1929, 8: 617-49.—Genni, A. [De- termination of the index of comfort by the method of air calories] Gig. bezopas. pat. truda, 1930, 7: 27-9.—Hill, L The influence of infra red radiation in relation to ventilation and heating. J. State M, Lond, 1931, 39: 683-7. ------& Taylor, H. J. Discomfort of close rooms caused by infra-red rays. Q. J. Exp. Physiol, Lond, 1933, 23: 35-47.—Houghten, h. C, Ferderber, M. B., & Gutberlet, C. Cooling workers in hot industry. Indust. M, 1941, 10: 460-3.—Ito, M. Influence of tropical environment and labor on the physical condition of the stokers. Bull. Nav. M. Ass, Tokyo, 1935, 24: No. 6, 42. ------Effects of certain medicines on workers in high atmos- pheric temperature. Ibid, 1936, 25: No. 12, 1. -----■ Influence of the intake of salts on the metabolism at high surrounding temperature. J. Orient. M, Dairen, 1936, 25: 93.—Kalmykov, P. [Masks for protection from the heat in summer] Voen. san. delo, 1937, No. 7, 33-5.—Keeping cool. Lancet, Lond, 1941, 2: 77.—Lehmann, G, & Szakall, A. Die Bedeutung des Flussigkeits- und Chlorersatzes fur die Leistungsfahigkeit des Hitzearbeiters. Arbeitsphysiologie, 1935-37, 9: 630-52.—Liese, W. Temperaturbeobachtungen im beheizten Raum und ihre hygienische Bedeutung. Ge- sundh. Ingenieur, 1933, 56: 541.—Marschak, M, & Klaus, L. Untersuchungen iiber die Warmeregulation; iiber die Wirkung der Wasser- und Kochsalzaufnahme auf den Kochsalzgehalt im menschlichen Schweiss und Blut bei hoher Umgebungs- temperatur. Arch. Hyg, Berl, 1929, 101: 297-307—Raschew- skaja, A, & Schochtowa, S. Die Rationalisierung des Trink- regimes in uberhitzten Werkstatten. Arch. Gewerbepath, 1932-33, 4: 715-26.—Reichard, J. D. An economical method of heat control in warm climates. Hosp. News, Wash, 1941, 8: No. 8, 19-22, 2 fig.—Schlegel, B. Experimentelle Unter- suchungen zur Besserung der Hitzevertraglichkeit des Men- schen. Klin. Wschr, 1941, 20: 506-10.—Strauss, W. Klima und Arbeit; der Energieverbrauch bei Arbeiten in der Warme. Arch. Gewerbepath, 1932-33, 4: 552-62— Vernon, H. M. The measurement of radiant heat in relation to human com- fort. J. Indust. Hvg, 1932, 14:95-111.—Warmth and comfort at work. Lancet, Lond, 1936, 2: 456. ---- Measurement. See also Calorimetry; Freezing point, De- termination, &c.; also in 3. ser. Thermometry; Temperature. For measurement of human temperature see under Heat [animal] American Institute of Physics. Tempera- ture; its measurement and control in science and industry. 1362p. 23>72cm. N. Y., 1941. Weber, R. L. Temperature measurement. 171p. 27^ x 21^cm. Ann Arb., 1941. Abbot, C. G. Smithsonian temperature measurements. In Temperature (Am. Inst. Physics) N. Y, 1941, 682-4.— Bennett, J. G. Standardization of thermometric methods in Great Britain. Ibid, 920-4.—Delmonte, J. Temperature measurements in the molding of plastics. Ibid, 898-904.— Dike, P. H. An industrial course in temperature measure- ments. Ibid, 317-20.—Dufton, A. F. The measurement of equivalent temperature. J. Hyg, Cambr, 1933, 33: 474.— Hardy, J. D, & Du Bois, E. F. The technic of measuring radiation and convection. J. Nutrit, 1938, 15: 461-75.— Houghten, F. C, & Olson, H. T. Measurement of surface temperatures. In Temperature (Am. Inst. Physics) N. Y, 1941, 855-61.—Howe, E. D, & Boelter, L. M. K. Institution in temperature measurement to mechanical engineering stu- dents. Ibid, 331-41.—Koppel, J. Der gegenwartige Stand der Temperaturmessungen und die Temperaturskala. Natur- wissenschaften, 1913, 1: 882-8.—London, N. [Experiments in determining the equivalent of radiation and convection heat, by the aid of the heat, produced by them] Gig. san, Moskva, 1939, 4: No. 12, 18-24.—Measurements of temperature at great heights. Nature, Lond, 1936, 137: 545.—Mulder, L. L. Die Messung von Temperaturen. Gesundh. Ingenieur, 1939, 62: 677-82.—Ribaud, G. Perfectionnements k la technique de la mesure des temperatures des flammes. C. rend. Acad. sc, 1937, 205: 901.—Saylor, C. P. Control and measurement of temperature under the microscope. In Temperature (Am. Inst. Physics) N. Y, 1941, 673-81.—Schulz, E. Vergleich und Berechnung von Heizwarmemengen. Gesundh. Ingenieur, 1934, 57: 161; 173.—Simon, F. The determination of tempera- ture below 1? K. Science Progr, Lond, 1939-40, 34: 31-46.— HEAT 410 HEAT Squire, C. F. Magnetic cooling; production and measurement of temperatures below 1? K. In Temperature (Am. Inst. Physics) N. Y, 1941, 745-56.—Swietoslawski, W., & Salce- wicz, J. L'application de la loi de refroidissement de Newton k la mesure de tres faibles effets themiiques. C. rend. Acad. sc, 1934, 199: 935-7.—Wing, P., jr, & Miller, N. A. High- speed temperature measurement in iietroleum refining. In Temperature (Am. Inst. Physics) N. Y, 1941, 634-8. ----- Measurement: Instruments. See also Psychrometer. Behar. M. F. On classifications of temperature instruments. In Temperature (Am. Inst. Physics) N. Y, 1941, 344-52.— Berthelot |New thermometer for determination of high temperature] Pharm. tid, Kbh, 1868, 7: 254-6.—Bowen, N. L. Geologic temperature recorders. In Temperature (Am. Inst. Physics') N. Y, 1941, 362-71.—Boyer, J. Un thermo- metre pour aveugles. Nature, Par, 1919, 47: 424.—Brom- bacher, W. G. Thermometers for aircraft. In Temperature (Am. Inst. Physics) N. Y, 1941, 917-9.—Bryant, J. M, & Webb, J. S. The determination of the Curie point tempera- ture by the high frequency resistance method. Rev. Sc. Instrum, 1939, 10: 47-50.—Busse, J. Liquid-in-glass ther- mometers. In Temperature (Am. Inst. Physics) N. Y, 1941, 228-55.—Champion, A. R, & Brokaw, G. K. A high-speed multiple-temperature recorder. Ibid, 624-8.—Daridon, H. Histoire du thermometre. Nature, Par, 1937, 65: pt 2, .")85- 7.—Emyrs-Roberts, E. A wax thermometer primarily designed for use in hot-air sterilizing chambers. Brit. M. J, 1018, 1: .Mi'.i. Evolution (The) of the thermometer. Science leaflet, 1934, 7: 22-6.—Faddis, M. O. A thermometer for sterile solutions. Am. J. Nurs, 1934, 34: 339.—Fantus, B. The 3 household thermometers. Hygeia, Chic, 1936, 14: 126.— Holmes, B. E. Vocal thermometers. Sc. Month, 1927, 25: 261-4.—Invention (L') du thermometre. Savoir, Par, 1922, 2: No. 32, 1.—KaurTmann, K. Ueber Wiirmezahler. Gesundh. Ingenieur, 1926, 49: 517-20.—Larsen, B. M, & Shenk, W. E. Temperature measurement with blocking-layer photocells. In Temperature (Am. Inst. Physics) N. Y, 1941, 1150-8 — Moreau, H. Etude pteliminaire de thermometres k mercure de precision en quartz fondu. C. rend. Acad, sc, 1937, 205: 007-9.—Ruelle, I. Presentation d'un thermometre differen- tielle k teglage automatique. C. rend. Soc. biol, 1914, 76: 42.—Smits, A, & Cannegieter, D. Direkte Methode zur Bestimmung der Kondensationswarme; Versuche mit nicht intensiv getrockneten Flussigkeiten. Zschr. phys. Chem, Abt. A, 1934, 168: 391; 1935, 172: 1.—Sokolov, F. V. [Making thermometers in Russia] Vest. Tsarskoselsk. Raiona, 1916, 2: No. 3, 5-12.—Stubbs, J. R, . In Temperature (Am. Inst. Physics) N. Y, 1941, 974-83.—Southard, J. C, & Nelson, R. A. Low temperature specific heats; the heat capacities of potassium chloride, potas-mm nitrate and sodium nitrate. J. Am. Chem. Soc, 1933, 55: 4865-9. ---- Therapeutic use. See also Aerothermotherapy; Bath, hot; Dia- thermy; Dressing; Fever therapy; Heliotherapy, &c. Deason, W. J. Thermogenic therapy. 39p. 8? [S. Louis, 1933] Aubel. La medication thermale. Ann. med. chir. centre Tours. 1904, 4: 31.—Best, W. P. Heat; its employment in physiotherapy. Nat. Eclect. M. Ass. Q, 1935-36, 27: 99.— Bierman, W. El uso teraoeutico de la elevaci6n termica local y general. Medicina, Mex, 1935, 15: 482-90.— Bram, L. Ueber Thermotherapie, namentlich in Berucksichtigung der Temperaturgrade. Heilkunde, Berl, 1906, 256-9.—( har- bonnier. A. La chaleur radiante therapeutique appliance au lit du mal.ide. Rev. gen. cli" ther, 1931, 45: 583.- -Cooksey, F. S. Heat therapy. Lancet. Loud, 1938.2: 1314.—Dognon, A. Chaleur. Hev.' physiot h. '■<, Pat.. 1038, 14: 173-8. ---__ & Biancani. Chaleur et uliei sons. [bid . 2.sn -5. Fantua, B. The therapy of the Cook County Hospital. .1. Am. M. Ass. 1934, 103: 000.—Foveau de ('ourmelles. la thermotherapie Rev. med. Par, 1913, 23: 183. Furslenberg, A. Fortschritte auf dem Gebiet der Hydro- Thermo- und ftmanat ionslhciapie Deut. med. Wschr., 1912. 38: 70-3.- Holman. H. I). I|(.,.U; its production, administration and therapeutic value. Med Rec, N. V, 1037, 145: 495-8.- Jenny. P. I, Heat, external therapeutic uses. In Cyclop. Med. (Picisol-Hoi tz) Phila' 1939, 7: 122--30.—Kellam, C, D. Thermo-therapy. Tr. .\l" Soc. Virginia, 1916, 46: 201-3.— Kellogg. J. H. Intensive thcrmotlieiapy. Good Health, 1939, 74: 262. -La Rochelle, F. D. Heat as applied to disease. Bull. OIL I'ract, 1934, 8: 36-9.—Lecce, M. Sulla teimoterapia. Ga/.z. internaz. med 1906, 9: 869-74. Leduc, S. Thermotherapie. ,1. physiother., Par, 1903, 1: 450-3.—Leudet. La medication thermale C. rend. Soc. hydrol med. Paris, 1904-5, 50: 41; 153.— I.ingbeek. lets over thermotherapie. Tschr. phys. ther. hyg, 1003, 177-8-1.- Marcuse, J. Historische Einleitung zum aclten Kapitel: Thermotherapie. In Handb. phvs. Ther. (A Goldscheidcr & I'. Jacob) Lpz, 1901, T. 1, 502-6- Moose, S. M. The rational therapeutic use of thermal agents with special reference to heat and cold. J. Am. Dent. Ass., 19.17 24: 185-96.—Nichols, A. B. Heat and cold. Am. J. Pharm., 1930, 102: 425-54.— Poenaru-Caplescu. [Actual value of heat n therapeutics] Romdnia med., 1032, 10: 239-42.— Riviere, J. A. La chaleur envkagec comme agent physi- cotlerapique. Congr. internat. med, 1006, 15. Congr, sect. 4, 96-104.—Roux, C. Le marteau de Mayor. Schweiz. med. Wschr, 1020, 59: 483-6. Rozenraad, <). Thermotherapv as a part of physical therapeutics. Boston M. «y; »: 429-35.-Foged, J. [Skin temperature of head and trunk Bibl. heger, 1929, 121: 539-63. . -— ?>« "Kfl^l - temperatur. Skand. Arch. Physiol, Berl, 1932 64 2ol 7»■ Freeman, H., & Linder, F. E. Some factors determining the variability of skin temperature. Arch. Int. M, 1934, 54: 081 -7. Also repr. ------& Nickerson, R. F. The bilateral symmetry of skin temperature. J. Nutrit, 1937, 13: 39-49.—Greulich, W. W, Day, H. G. [et al] Skin temperature. Monogr. Soc. Res. Child Develop, 1938, 3: No. 2, 72-4.—Hardy, J. D, & Du Bois, E. F. The significance of the average temperature of the skin. In Temperature (Am. Inst. Physics) N. Y, 1941, 537-43.—Helson, H, & Quantius. L. Changes in skin tem- perature following intense stimulation. J. Exp. Psychol, 1934, 17: 20-35.—Ingram, P. W. On normal variations in the cutaneous temperatuie of the extremities. Edinburgh M. J, 1936, 43: 672-9.—Kausch, W. Die Thermometerhaltung in der Achselhohle. Med. Klin, Berl, 1912, 8: 1538.—Kin. R. Studies on the skin temperature; the range and intensity of influence of the local cooling and heating. J. Chosen M. Ass, 1936, 26: 38. ----— The change of skin temperature by intercepting sun light and cold air current with Korean clothes. Ibid, 1937, 27: 39. ------ The cooling effect of air current upon the sliu temperature. Ibid, 72.—Koizumi, S. Pharma- kologische Studien iiber die Hauttemperatur. Jap. J. M. Sc, 1938, 11: Proc. Pharm, 16.—Lenti, C. Eyaporazione e tem- peratura cutanea durante il lavoro. Arch, fisiol. Fir.. 1937, 37: 326-33.—Loewy, A, & Uhlmann, E. Temperatur- und Feuchtigkeitsvcrhaltnisse in der Uebergangssehicht der mensch- lichen Haut. Zschr. ges. phys. Ther, 1933, 45: 183-96 — Maddock, W. G.. & Coller, F. A. Skin temperature of the extremities and basal heat production. Proc. Soc. Exp. Biol, N. Y, 1933, 30: 016— Marshak, M. E. [Temperature of the skin as indicator of the reaction of the skin to temperature, humidity and the movement of air] Gig. bezopas. pat. truda, 1930, 8: 11-25.—Medvedeva, N. B. [Heat conductibility of the skin in the rat] J. m4d, Kiev, 1939, 9: 129-45.—Mendelson, E. S. Measurement of the suoerficial temperature gradient in man. Am. J. Phvsiol, 1935-36, 114: 642-7.—Milimovka, M. E. [On measurement of skin temperature; physiological fluctuations of skin temperature and its clinical significance] Fizioterapia, Moskva, 1939, No. 5. 39-46.—Miura, V. The effect of variations in relative humidity upon skin temperature and sense of comfort. Am. J. Hyg, 1931, 13: 432-59.— Murlin, J. R. Skin temperature, its measurement and signifi- cance for energy metabolism. Erg. Physiol, 1939, 42: 153- 227.—Nemenov, M. I, & Mozharova, E. N. [Effect of roentgen irradiation of the centers of the vegetative nervous system on the temperature of the skin] Vest, rentg, 1938, 20: 8-19.— Pavlenko A. M. [Determination of the surface temperature of the human body] J. med, Kiev, 1935, 5: 631-7.—Razirha, A & Zselyonka, L. [Temperature of the skin of healthy indi- viduals] Magv. orv. arch, 1940, 41: 504-11, tab—Roeder. F. Grundversuche zur Frage der Warmeregulation des Menschen, die Messuns der Warmeleitzahl der menschlichen Haut unit ihre Veriinderlichkcit. Zschr. Biol, 1934. 95: 164-8.—Ruhnau, A & Starfinger, W. Messung und Bewertung der Haut- temperatur. Med. Welt, 1936, 10: 77-80.—Saidinan, J. Notes sur la mesure du rayonnement de la peau. G. rend. Soc. biol, 1934, 115: 150-3—Sartorius, F, Manicke, R, & Gemecke, A. Studien iiber Streuung und indiyiduelles Ver- halten der Hauttemperatur bei klinisch gesunden Personen. Arch Hyg, Miinch, 1937-38, 119: 271-88.—Scheurer, O, & Schliiter, E. Wie reagiert die -Hauttemperntur au (ortliche Kiiltereize? Zschr. ges. exp. Med, 1937, 101 D9-27.— Seligman, A. La temperature de la peau. Medecine, Par, 1026-27 8: 752-6— Setoyama, H. Zum Studium der Haut- remWraturen Jap. J. M. Sc, 1938-39, 5: Proc. Int. Med ■>73 -Sheard"; C, & Williams, M. M. D. Skin temperatures of the extremities and basal metabolic rates ™ "^xdnate having aormal circulation. Proc. Mayo Clin, 1940, 15 75S-62. ™_ & Horton, B. T. Skin temperatures of the extremities and effective temperature. Collect. Papers Mayo Chn, 1938, 10 963i -_____Skin temperatures of the extremities under various' environmental and physiological conditions In Temperature (Am. Inst. Physics) N. Y, 1941, 557 /U. SoHto M. Particolari caratteristiche dii talune curve termiche biascellar Gior. clin. med, 1926, 7: 684-91-Talbot FB. We Hauttemperatur und ihre Beziehung rles Korpers Kin. Wschr, 1933, 12: 809-14. Williams, lvi. des «-°njersi & gheard> c. The relationship between ?ne skin temperatures of the extremities and the effective tem- perature scale. Proc. Mayo Chn, 1939, 14: 008-70. ---- Regulation. See also subheadings Loss; Variation Du Bois E F. Lane medical lectures: the mechanism of heat loss and temperature regula- tion 95p 8? Stanford Univ., Cahf., 1937. Pbarse A S., & Hall, F. G. Homoiother- misnr the origin of warm-blooded vertebrates. 119p ' 8? N. Y., 1928. . White E D The mechanism by which the mean temperature of the human body is main- lined F341p. 8? Rockford, III. |193oJ Barbour HG. The development of hoinoothermy m ^JlaJT^Kei^A1^ ^f sTudi^f HEAT, ANIMAL 420 HEAT, ANIMAL tion. Annual Rev. Physiol, 1939, 1: 109-30. The operating characteristics of the human thermo-regulatory mechanism. In Temperature (Am. Inst. Physics) N. Y, 1941, 522-8.—Clark, G. Temperature regulation in the cat. Sum- maries Doct. Diss. Northwest. Univ., 1939, 7: 183-6— Cotte, J. Variations locales et maintien de la temperature interne chez l'homeotherme. C. rend. Soc. biol, 1930, 104: 211-3 — Deighton, T. Physical factors in body temperature main- tenance and heat elimination. Physiol. Rev, 1933, 13: 427- 65.—Dontas, S. Ueber den Mechanismus der Warmeregulation. Arch. ges. Physiol, 1938-39, 241: 612-29.—Du Bois, E. F. The mechanism of heat loss and temperature regulation. Ann. Int. M, 1938-39, 12: 388-95.—Eisentraut, M. Biologische Studien im bolivianischen Chaco; iiber die Warmeregulation beim Dreizehenfaultier (Bradypus tridactylus L.) Zschr. vergl Physiol, 1932, 16: 39-47.—Field, J, II. Temperature regulation in health. Contact Point, 1938-39, 16: 103-8.— Frank, C. La causa principale della termogenesi e della termo- regolazione risiede nella corteccia cerebrale. In his Biomec. cerebr, Pisa, 1939, 470-87.—Franz, H. Untersuchungen iiber den Warmehaushalt der Poikilothermen. Biol. Zbl, 1930, 50: 158-82.—Gasnier, A., & Mayer, A. Sur quelques modalites de la thermoregulation. Ann. physiol. Par, 1933, 9: 943-52. ------ Recherches sur les modalites de la thermoregulation. Ibid, 1934, 10: 147; 1937, 13: 111. ------ Caracteres et lois de la regulation de la thermolyse latente; contribution k l'etude gdn£rale des regulations organiques. Ibid, 1938, 14: 100-21, ch.—Gessler, H. Die Warmeregulation des Menschen. Erg. Physiol, 1928, 26: 158-234.—Giaja, A. Contributionkl'etude de la thermoregulation des oiseaux. Ann. physiol, Par, 1931, 7: 13-80.—Grandpierre, R. M. J. Les bases physiologiques de la thermoregulation; pour servir k l'etude de ses incidences en milieu militaire. Rev. Serv. san. mil. Par, 1939, 110: 583- 630.—Haist, R. E. Heat regulation. Univ. Toronto M. J, 1933, 11: 18-24.—Isenschmid, R. Physiologie der Warme- regulation. In Handb. norm. path. Physiol. (A. Bethe, G. von, Bergman [et al]) Berl, 1926, 17: 3-85.—Kolmer, W. Zur Frage der Warmeregulation bei den Monotremen. Arch. ges. Physiol, 1928-29, 221: 319.—Korzhuev, P. A. [The origin of homoiothermism] Lsp. sovrem. biol, 1940, 12: 488-503.— KrUger, P. Ueber die Bedeutung der ultraroten Strahlen fiir den Wiirmehaushalt der Poikilothermen. Biol. Zbl, 1929, 49: 65-82.—Lippelt, H. Zur Physiologie und Pathologie der Warme- regulierung. In Festschr. B. Nocht, Hamb, 1937, 267-70.— Lombroso, U. Fenomeni paradossi nella termoregolazione. Athena, Roma, 1936, 5: 343-7.—Meyer, H. H. Zur Lehre von der Warmeregulation. Klin. Wschr, 1935, 14: 962.—Miiller, E. F, & Petersen, W. F. Lymph production and heat regula- tion. Proc. Soc. Exp. Biol, N. Y, 1928-29, 26: 169.—Ranson, S. W. Note with regard to temperature regulation. Psycho- Bomat. M, 1939, 1: 92.—Scott, J. C, & Bazett, H. C. Tem- perature regulation. Annual Rev. Physiol, 1941, 3: 107-30.— Slonim, A. D., Bezuevskaia, R. I., & Zhila, E. S. [Material for comparative physiology of thermo-regulation; physiology of thermoregulation in rodents and insect-eaters] Biull. eksp. biol. med, 1940, 10: 38-40.—Slonim, A. D, & Shcherbakova, O. P. [Comparative physiology of thermoregulation; physiol- ogy of thermoregulation in the lower apes] Arkh. biol. nauk, 1939, 55: No. 3, 3-19.—Thauer, R. Der Mechanismus der Warmeregulation. Erg. Physiol, 1939, 41: 607-805.—The- venon, J. A. Mise au point sur le mecanisme de la thermo- regulation. Gaz. hop, 1931, 104: 789-92.—Tonkikh, A. V. [Present state of the theory of thermoregulation] Priroda, Leningr, 1936, 25: 50-6.—Weiss, O. Die Temperatur- regelung bei Warmblutern. Med. Welt, 1927, 1: 1153-6.— Weiss, W. Von der Korpertertemperatur. Mitt. Biochem, 1940, 47: 22-4.—Witz, H. E. Ueber verschiedenartige Warme- regelungsvorgange. Fortsch. Med, 1935, 53: 323-5. ■ Regulation, central and neural. Bruman, F. *Ein Beitrag zur Physiologie der zentralen Temperaturregulation [Zurich] p. 142- 58. 8? Berl., 1929. Also Arch. ges. Physiol, 1929, 222: Streerath, E. *Die Wirksamkeit der Warme- centren im Gehirn [Bern] 26p. 8? Lpz., 1910. Abe, K. Frage auf die Ansicht, dass die Warmecentren die \\ armeregulationscentren seien. Jap. J. M. Sc, 1939—10, 12: Proc. Pharm, 139-42.—Asada, T. Einfluss des Warmestiches auf den Blutzucker und die Blutmilchsaure des Kaninchens Mitt. Med. Akad. Kioto, 1935, 14: 1256-66.—Asher, L., & Scheinfinkel, N. Neuer Nachweis der Warmebildung im Muskel durch sympathische Impulse. Helvet. med. acta, 1941 8- 327-35.—Beaton, L. E, McKinley, W. A. [et al] Localization of cerebral center activating heat-loss mechanisms in monkeys J. Neurophysiol, 1941, 4: 478-85.—Conklin, R. E. Vagai tonicity as related to body temperature in the snake. Am J Physiol, 1940, 129: 338.—Dworkin, S. Observations on the central control of shivering and of heat regulation in the rabbit Ibid, 1930, 93: 227-44.—Enderlen, E, & Gessler, H. Die Bedeutung der Ganglia stellate fiir die Warmeregulation Deut Zschr. Chir, 1927, 206: 1-1.— Frazier, C. H, Alpers, B. J., & Lewy, F. H. The anatomical localization of the hypothalamic centre for the regulation of temperature. Brain, Lond 1936 59: 122-9—Fujiki, S., & Kushima, T. On the relationship between diencephalon and body temperature, blood pressure Jap. J. M. Sc. 1938-39, 5: Proc. Int. Med, 92.—Glaubach, S.', & Pick. E. P. Ueber zentralc Teniperaturregulierung nach Au&M'lialtung des hypothalaiiuscben Warmezentrums. Arch exp. Path, Berl, 1933, 173: 571-9.—Haller, R. Fortgesetzte Untersuchungen fiber die kalorigene Wiikung des Sympathicus auf die quergestreifte Muskulatur. Ausz. Inaugur. Diss. Med Fak. Univ. Bern (1935-37) 1938, No. 96. 1-3.—Hasama. B. Pharmakologische und physiologische Studien iiberdie Sehweiss- zentren; zur Frage nach der Beeinflussung der Sclueiss- sekretion und der Korpertemperatur durch die Medulla oblongata. Arch. exp. Path., Lpz, 1930, 153: 257-90.— Hermann, H, Jourdan, F. [et al.] Persistance de capacity thermoregulatrices chez le chien sans moelle bistellectomise\ puis bivagotomise. Ann. physiol. Par, 1939, 15: 852-7.— Hyndman, O. R, & Wolkin, J. The autonomic mechanism of heat conservation and dissipation; effects of heating the body; evidence for the existence of capillary dilator nerves in anterior roots. Am. Heart J, 1941, 22: 289-304, pl. ------ Effects of cooling the body. -Ibid, 1942, 23: 43-58, pl.—Issekutz, B. von, jr. Die Rolle des Zentralnervensystems und der Schild- druse bei der Warmeregulation. Arch. ges. physiol, 1936-37, 238: 787-801.—Kayser, C. Contribution k l'etude du meca- nisme nerveux de la regulation thermique; regulation chimique et metabolisme de l'eau. Ann. physiol. Par, 1929, 5: 131- 223.—Keller, A. D., & Hare, W. K. Heat regulation in medul- lary and mid-brain preparations. Proc. Soc. Exp. Biol, N. Y, 1932, 29: 1067.—Kleyntjens, F. Recherches sur la physio- pathologie des centres thermoregulateurs. Acta brevia neerl, 1939, 9: 219-22. Also C. rend. Soc. biol, 1939, 132: 55-9 — Kushizaki, S. Experimentelle Untersuchung iiber den Einfluss des Vorderhirns auf Blutbild und Korpertemperatur; iiber den Zusammenhang des Vorderhirns mit Blutbild und Korpcr- fiiipeiatur. Fukuoka acta med, 1935, 28: 75-8.—Lakin, C. E. Heat regulation; centres in brain. Tr. M. Soc. London, 1934, 57: 300-13.—Olnianskaia, R. P, & Slonim, A. D. [Effect of the cerebral cortex on the regulation of heat in the body; experiments on dogs] J. Physiol. USSR, 1938, 25: 812-22 — Pupier, A, Pupier, A., & Prieur, R. Nouveaux faits montrant l'action thermique sur le bulbe. C. rend. Acad, sc, 1933, 196: 1549.—Ranson, S. W. The hypothalamus as a thermostat regulating body temperature. Psychosomat. M, 1939, 1: 486-95. ------■ & Clark, G. The nervous control of tempera- ture regulation. Arch. Neur. Psychiat, Chic, 1939, 41: 1064.—Ranson, S. W, & Ingram, W. R. Hypothalamus and regulation of body temperature. Proc. Soc. Exp. Biol, N. Y, 1934-35, 32: 1439-41. ------ & Fisher, C. Hypothalamic regulation of temperature in the monkey. Arch. Neur. Psychiat., Chic, 1937, 38: 445-66.—Saeki, R. Das Grosshirn und die Korpertemperatur. Nagoya J. M. Sc, 1935, 9: 235-41.— Scheinfinkel, N. Thermoelektrische Untersuchungen fiber den warmebildenden Einfluss des Nervus sympathicus auf die quergestreifte Muskulatur. Schweiz. med. Wschr, 1938, 68: 965-8.—Schmid, M. Untersuchungen iiber den Einfluss des Sympathicus und von Adrenalin auf die Warmebildung im Muskel. Ausz. Inaugur. Diss. Med. Fak. Univ. Bern (1935-37) 1938, No. 74, 1-8.—Sinelnikov, E. J. Ueber den Einfluss der Grosshirnhemispharen auf die Warmeregulation. Arch. ges. Physiol, 1928-29, 221: 549-61.—Slonim, A. D. [Effect of the cerebral cortex on the regulation of heat in the body; experi- ments on mice] J. Physiol. USSR, 1938, 25: 823-6. ----- Olnianskaia, R. P. [et al] [Central regulation of heat and metabolism in the animal organism] Sborn. Vsesoiuz. sezd. fiziol, 1937, 6. Congr, 411-8.-—Sutkowaja. Zur Frage uber das Zentrum der Warmeregulation (vergleichende Cytoarchi- tektonik des Hypothalamus) Zschr. ges. Neur. Psychiat, 1928, 115: 272-302.—Teague, R. S., & Ranson, S. W. The role of the anterior hypothalamus in temperature regulation. Am. J. Physiol, 1936, 117: 562-70.—Thauer, R., & Peters, G. Warmeregulation ohne Hypothalamus. Verh. Deut. Ges. inn. Med, 1937, 49. Kongr, Sekt. inn. Med, 188-90.—Thomas, A. La regulation thermique et la region infundibulo-tuberienne. Ann. med. psychol. Par, 1934, 92: pt 2, 329-31. Also Arch. Neur. Psychiat, Chic, 1936, 35: 200-2. Also Bruxelles med, 1934-35, 14: 1455. Also Bull, med. Par, 1934, 48: 539. Also Encephale, 1934, 29: 575-8.—Trarnit, H. J. Die Warme- bildung bei reflektorischer Erregung und die Verteilung der Warmebildung auf die einzelnen Riickenmarksabschnitte. Zschr. Biol, 1938-39, 99: 108-14.—Wurth, W. Das Steigen und Sinken der Temperatur nach Verletzung der Warmezentren unter Berucksichtigung einiger Begleitumstande. Arch. Physiol, Lpz, 1911, 447-80. ---- Regulation, chemical and endocrine. Bormann, F. von. Die Korpertemperatur beim mannlichen und weiblichen, beim kastrierten und feminierten Meer- schweinchen. Zschr. ges. exp. Med, 1926, 51: 38-47.— Cannon, W. B. An endocrine factor in the chemical control of body temperature. Tr. Ass. Am. Physicians, 1924, 39: 162- 6.—Daly, C, & Dill, D. B. Salt economy in humid heat. Am. J. Physiol, 1937, 118: 285-9.—Galperina, R. K. [Thermic regulation in animals with injured endocrine system] Arkh. biol. nauk, 1930, 30: 549-59.—Geiger, E. Versuche iiber die Beziehungen zwischen den warme- und blutzuckerregulato- rischen Einrichtungen. Arch. exp. Path, Lpz, 1927, 121: ^Z-8,2- ------ Warmeregulation und innere Sekretion. Klin. Wschr, 1933, 12: 1313-7.—Gelineo, S. Sur la seconde thermo- regulation chimique. C. rend. Soc. biol, 1936, 122: 337-40 — Grafe, E. Warmehaushalt und endokrines System. Klin. Vvschr, 1934, 13: 1705-9.—Hemingway, A. Chemical tem- perature regulation of the dog. Am. J. Physiol., 1941, 133: HEAT, ANIMAL 421 HEAT, ANIMAL g23 ._____& Hathaway, S. R. An investigation of chemical temperature regulation. Ibid, 134: 596-602.—Korenchevsky, V The influence of the removal of the thyroid, parathyroid and sexual glands and of thyroid feeding upon the regulation of the body temperature of rabbits. J. Path. Bact, Edinb, 1926, 29: 461-72.—Martin, S. J, & Maresh, F. Temperature studies in normal and suprarenalectomized rats. Am. J. Physiol, 1933,105: 273-86.—Pomerat, C. M, & Zarrow, M. X. A method of temperature analysis of endocrine function. Ibid, 1936, 116: 122. ____. Regulation: Development. Antoshkina, E. D. [Ontogenesis of thermoregulation; development of thermoregulation in rats, reared in normal conditions] J. Physiol. USSR, 1939, 26: 3-15. ------ [Onto- genesis of thermoregulation; development of thermoregulation in rats, reared in conditions of high and low temperatures] Ibid, 16-29. ------ [Ontogenetic development of thermal regulation; age peculiarities of the reaction in rats to heat puncture] Ibid, 1941, 30: 160-8.—Boling, J. L., Blandau, R. J. [et al] Post-parturitional heat responses of newborn and adult guinea pigs; data on parturition. Proc. Soc. Exp. Biol, N. Y, 1939. 42: 128-32.—Eisentraut, M. Die Entwicklung der Warmeregulation beim jungen Igel Biol. Zbl, 1935, 55: 45-53.—Ginglinger, A, & Kayser, C. Etablissement de la thermoregulation chez les homeothermes au cours du develop- pement. Ann. physiol. Par, 1929, 5: 710-58. Also C. rend. Soc. biol, 1929, 101: 711-4.—Gulick, A. The establishment of temperature control in infant rats. Proc. Internet. Physiol. Congr. (1935) 1938, 15. Congr, 532.—Kendeigh, S. C. The relation of metabolism to the development of temperature regulation in birds. J. Exp. Zool, 1939, 82: 419-38.—Males, B Sviluppo della capacita termoregolatrice nei neonati omo- termi. Boll. Sc. ital. biol. sper, 1929, 4: 252-5.—Pincus, G, Sterne, D, & Enzmann, E. The development of temperature regulation in the mouse. Proc. Nat. Acad. Sc. U. S, 1933, 19: 729-33 —Slonim, A. D. [Evolution of heat regulation in the animal body] Usp. sovrem. biol, 1937, 6: 52-67.—Wodak, E. Ein kasuistischer Beitrag zur Parallelitiit der Temperatur- reaktion in der Deszendentreihe. Mschr. Ohrenh, 1932, 66: 50. ---- Regulation: Relation to respiration. See also Respiration. Alpern, D. E, & Arlozorov, Z. G. [Participation of the lungs in chemical regulation of heat] Biull. eksp. biol. med, 1940, 9: 198 ------ The participation of the lungs in> thermoregula- tion. Bull. biol. med. exp. URSS, 1940, 9: 258.—Anrep, G. V., & Hammouda, H. Observations on panting. J. Physiol, Lond, 1932-33, 77: 16-34.—Berg, H. Zur Frage der Warme- regulation durch die Lungen. Zschr. klin. Med, 1933, 125: 1-8.—Dontas, S. L'eau de l'organisme et la polypnee thermi- que. Sunti Congr. internaz. fisiol, 1932, 14. Congr, 69-72 — Fraenkel, G. S, & Herford, G. V. B. The physiological action of abnormally high temperatures on poikilotherm animals; the respiration at high sublethal and lethal temperatures. J. Exp. Biol, Lond, 1940, 17: 386-95.—Frohlich, A, & Zak, E. Perspiratio insensibilis negativa und die den Vv assergehalt des Blutes regulierende Fahigkeit der Lungen. Wien. klin. Wschr, 1937, 50: 523-7.—Jacqueot, R, & Mayer, A. Polypnee thermique et teneur en eau de l'air expire. C. rend. Soc. biol, 1925, 93: 1471-4.—Magne, H. La polypnee thermique et les phenomenes sectetoires qui 1'accompagnent. Bull. Acad. vet. France, 1928, 1: 301-3.—Mutow, T. On the reflex heat- tachvpnoea. Tohoku J. Exp. M, 1937, 31: 186-96—Randall, W. C, & Hiestand, W. A. Panting and temperature regulation in the chicken. Am. J. Physiol, 1939, 127: 761-7.—Veselkin, P. N. Du mecanisme de la polypnee thermique. Hull. biol. med. exp. URSS, 1938, 6: 479-81. ------ [Thermo-regulation in fever and over-heating; mechanism of the origin of thermic dyspnea in relation to direct temperature sensitivity of the heat centers] J. Physiol. USSR, 1939, 26: 672-86. ---- Regulation: Relation to water metabolism. See also subheading Loss; also Water metab- olism. Barbour, H. G, & Aydelotte, B. F. Heat regulation and water exchange; anhydremia with liver hydration of neurogenic origin. Am. J. Physiol, 1933, 104: 127-38.—Barbour, H. G, Dawson, M. H, & Neuwirth, I. Heat regulation and water exchange; water, salt and lipoid accumulation in the serum as a preliminary to sweating. Ibid, 1925, 74: 204-23—Barbour, H. G., & Gilman, A. Heat regulation and water exchange; the subservience of vapor pressure homeostasis to temperature homeostasis. Ibid, 1934, 107: 70-5.—Barrett, J. W. The effect of exercise in hot atmospheres upon the salt-water balance of human subjects. Med. J. Australia, 1941, 2: 340 — Dontchev, L, & Kayser, C. Regulation thermique et mouve- ments d'eau chez le pigeon. C. rend. Soc. biol, 1933, it a. 1074-6 ------ Part prise par les reserves d eau tissulaires. Ibid, 1936, 121: 963-5. - - Part prise par la reabsorption d'eau dans le tube digestif et la secretion urinaire. Ibid, 966-8. ------ Reserve d'eau des muscles et activite lonction- nelle. Ibid, 968-70.—Gregory, R. A, & Lee, D. H. K. ine effect of water intake upon human reactions to reduced cooling powers. J. Physiol, Lond, 1936, 86: 204-18—Heat and sweating. Malay. M. J, 1937, 12: 160-2.—Kayser, C. Regu- lation thermique et metabolisme de l'eau. Ann. physiol. Par, 1928,4:644-8. ------ Contribution a l'etude de la regulation thermique; remission d'eau et le rapport HjO: O2 chez quelques espdces homeothermes adultes et en cours de croisance. Ibid, 1930, 6: 721-44.—Kuno, Y, & Ikeuchi, K. On sweating in man caused by the effect of heat, and also the variations of the body and the skin temperatures. J. Orient. M, Dairen, 128, 9: 35-8.—Kuo, K. W. On mental sweating at high atmospheric temperature, including a paradoxical phenomenon in sweating on the palm of the hand. Ibid, 1931, 14: 33.—Laszlo, D. Wasserstoffwechsel und Warmeumsatz. Verh. Deut. Ges. inn. Med, 1930, 42. Kongr, 93-100.—Lee, D. H. K., & Mulder, A. G. Some immediate effects of reduced cooling powers upon the water balance and related effects in the human subject. J. Physiol, Lond, 1935, 84: 410-32.—Lee, D. H. K., Murray, R. E. [et al] The effect of exercise in hot atmospheres upon the salt-water balance of human subjects. Med. J. Australia, 1941, 2: 249-58.—Mayer, A, & Nichita, G. Metabolisme de l'eau et metabolisme minimum en fonction de la temperature. Ann. physiol. Par, 1929, 5: 521-6.—Pi-Suner, J. La movilizaci6n del agua en la regulation termica. Ciencia, Mex, 1940, 1: 245-53.—Pi-Suner Bayo, J. El mecanismo de movilizaci6n de agua en la termoregulacion. Med. ibera, 1934, 28: pt 2, 101.— Puddu, V., & Vallogini, P. Studi sull'imbibizione del tessuto muscolare striato di omeotermo; la curva normale di imbibi- zione; azione di alcuni ormoni. Boll. Soc. ital. biol. sper, 1934, 9: 523.—Rey, P. Action de la temperature sur la teneur en eau de Rana viridis. C. rend. Soc. biol, 1936, 121: 1271-3 — Saito, K. On local sweating on the'heated area of the skin in man. J. Orient. M, Dairen, 1930, 13: 53.—Schliiter, E. Untersuchungen iiber die Warmeregulation; iiber die Haut- wasserabgabe bei Einschrankung der Fliissigkeitszufuhr. Arch. ges. Physiol, 1925, 210: 432-5.—Wassell, G. K. Increased vaporization of water by the postoperative patient in summer. Univ. Hosp. Bull, Ann Arb, 1938, 4: 26-8.—Water require- ments of workers under heat pressure. J. Am. M. Ass, 1939, 113: 1748.—Zamychkina, K. S, & Andreeva, E. I. Additional regulators of the organism (excretory paths) in conditions of exposure to high temperature. Bull. biol. med. exp. URSS, 1938, 6: 467-9. ------ [Auxiliary regulators of the constitu- tion (excretory ducts) in conditions of high temperature on the animal body] J. Physiol. USSR, 1939, 26: 83-8.—Zvereva, N., & Volkova, A. Contributions to the methods of studying the thermoregulation reaction in man; effect of various temperatures and of physical strain on water secretion by the skin. Bull. biol. med. exp. URSS, 1938, 6: 486-9. ---- Regulation, vasomotor. Albert, F. L'exploration thermometrique applique a l'etude de la vasomotricite peripherique. Bull. Acad. med. Belgique, 1938, 6. ser, 2: 517-38, 6 pl—Burton, A. C, & Bazett, H. C. The measurement of vasomotor reactions to temperature changes by means of a bath calorimeter. Am. J. Physiol, 1936, 116: 21.—Burton, A. C, & Taylor, R. M. A study of the adjustment of peripheral vascular tone to the requirements of the regulation of body temperature. Ibid, 1940 129:565-77.—Dubreuil, G. Les appareils vaso-sensoriels de thermostabilisation. Bull. Acad, med. Par, 1935, 3. ser, 113: 892-8.—Herrington, L. P, Winslow, C. E. A, & Gagge, A. P. The relative influence of radiation and convection upon vasomotor temperature regulation. Am. J. Physiol, 1937, 120: 133-43.—Herz, M. Ueber die Teilnahme der kleinsten Gefasse an der Reaktion nach thermischen Einflussen. Zschr. diat. phys. Ther, 1904-5, 8: 562-6—Jung, R,Doupe, J, & Carmichael, E. A. Shivering: a clinical study of the influence of sensation. Brain, Lond, 1937, 60: 28-38—Lehmann, G. Der L. Hillsche Nasenreflex und seine Bedeutung fur die Kenntnis der thermoregulatorischen Hautreflexe. Arbeits- physiologie, 1938-39, 10: 418-35— Nafe, J. P, & Wagoner, K. S The effect of thermal stimulation upon dilatation and con- striction of the blood vessels of the skin of a contralateral hand. J Psychol,Provincet, 1936,2:461-77.—Pickering, G.W. The vasomotor regulation of heat loss from the human skin in relation to external temperature. Heart, Lond.. 1932,16:115r35. & Hess W. Vasodilatation in the hands and feet in response to warming the body. Clin. Sc, Lond, 1933-34, 1: 213-23.— Roth G M„ Allen, E. V., & Sheard, C. Relationship between calorimetric determinations of the upper extremities and the basal metabolic rates of normal subjects. Am. J. ^^01, 1941 133- 431.—Uprus, V., Gaylor, J. B., & Carmichael, E. A. Vasodilatation and vasoconstriction in response to warming and cooling the body; a criticism of methods. Chn. be, Lond., 19^36 2: 301-16.-Wagoner, K. S. The effect of warmth and cold stimulation of one hand upon the skin temperature of the contralateral hand. J. Psychol, Provincet 1936 2: 451-9. Havermann, E. C. The effect of thermal stimula- ------/2cm. Lyon, 1939. Also Schweiz. Arch. Tierh, 1941, 83: 381. . Caltabiano, »• Effetti del pretrattamento con ca cio nell rpo- termia passiva. Fol. med. Nap, 1937, 23: 141-51. *us»"Ki- T. Ueber die subUminale Temperatur bei japanischen Kindern. HEAT, ANIMAL 422 HEAT, ANIMAL i>m I. Dis. Inf., Kyoto, 1927, 2: 118. -Giaja, J, & Gelineo, S. I !n pothermie et ii thermogene-e. Arch, internat. physiol, liege, 1930, 32: 237-50.—Glinchikov, V. I. [Subnormal tem- peratures] Klin, med, Moskva, 1932, 10: 1029-32.—Hamilton, J. B. The effect of hvpothermic states upon reflex and central nervous system activity. Vale J. Biol, 1936-37, 9: 327-32. ------Dresbach, M, & Hamilton, R. S. Cardiac changes during progressive hypothermia. Am. J. Physiol, 1937, 118: 71-6.—Hines, E. A. Intermittent hvpothermia. In Pract. Libr.'M. & S. (Appleton) N. Y, 1938, Suppl, 451-5. ---;— & Bannick, E. G. Intermittent hypothermia with disabling hvperhidrosis: report of a case with successful treatment. Proc. Mayo Chn, 1934, 9: 705-8.—Licht, H. Zum Mecha- nismus der Ciitertemperatur. Med. Klin, Berl, 1927, 23: 1923-6- Marchand, L, rXr Olivier, M. Trois cas d'hypothermie d'origine nerveuse. C. rend. Congr. alien, neur. France (1907) 1908, 17. Congr, 142-53.—Moore, L. M. Hypothermia due to localized lesions in midbrain of rabbit. Proc. Soc. Exp. Biol M, N. Y, 1028-29, 26: 48.—Rosenthal, F, Licht, H, it I.auterbach. F. Der Mechanismus der Kuhl- und Krampf- gifte (ein Beitrag zum nervosen Mechanismus der Unter- temperatur) Arch. exp. Path, Lpz, 1925, 106: 233-64.— Van't Hoff, J. H. Ueber die Subtemperaturen von Rekon- valeszenten [Auszug von dem Tagcbuch van't Hoffs, erstattet von B. Laquer] Berl khn. AVschr, 1912, 49: 870. ---- Variation. Lekexe, G. J. *Contribution a l'etude de l'instabilite thermique en dehors des infections. 50p. 8? Par., 1935. Burckhardt, O. Beobachtungen uber Korpcrtemperaturen; der normale Temperatur-Kurventypus und die Bedeutung etwelcher Abweichungen von demselben. Gyn. helvet, Geneve, 1911, 11: 346-56.—Coronado Hernandez. Las variaciones de la temperatura del organismo por el ejercicio ffsico. Med. ibera, 1934, 28:784.—Cotte, J. Variations thermi- ques en des points symetriqucs du corps. C. rend. Soc. biol, 1931, 108: 1131.—Crozier, W. J. On the modification of temperature characteristics. J. Gen. Physiol, 1934-35, 18: 801-7. Also repr.—Dill. D. B, Hall, F. C. [et al] Studies of temperature regulation in white men and Negroes. Am. J. Physiol, 1940, 129: 447.—Haward, H. H. The variations of normal temperature. Brit. M. J, 1923, 1: 17.—Laroche, G, & Saidman. J. Variations de la temperature superficielle du corps. Ann. Inst, actin. Par, 1935-36, 10: 186-9. Also C. rend. Soc. biol, 1936, 122: 7-10.—Michalowicz. Sur les oscillations de la temperature humaine; recherches faites k un millieme de degte ptes. Tr. sc. Clin. inf. Univ. Varsovie, 1930, 421-60. Also Rev. fr. p6diat, 1930, 6: 137-76.—Poelchau. Temperaturbeobachtungen in der eigenen Familie. Med. Klin, Berl, 1934, 30: 574-6.—Rautmann, H. Untersuchungen uber die Variabilitat der Korpertemperatur bei Gesunden. Zschr. ges. Anat, 2. Abt, 1927-28, 13: 588-92.—Thiele, F. H, & Embleton, D. Some observations on the production of temperature variations. Zschr. Immunforsch, 1912-13, 16: Orig, 178-223. ---- Variation: Age. See also subheading Regulation: Development. Rougon, P. *Des variations et de la valeur semeiologique de la temperature de l'enfant au point de vue clinique et physiologique. 60p. 8? Montpel., 1910. Bayley, N, & Stolz, H. R. Maturational changes in rectal temperatures of 61 infants from 1 to 36 months. Child Develop 1937, 8: 195-206.—Belehradek, J. L'age de 1'organisme influe- t-il toujours sur la grandeur des coefficients de temperature? C. rend. Soc. biol, 1931, 107: 730-2. —Cometto, C. S. Re- sultado de la investigation sobre la temperatura de 55,000 alumnos de las escuelas primarias de la provincia de Buenos Aires. Actas Congr. nac. med, Rosario, 1934, 5: pt 4, 1329-34 Also Sem. med, B. Air, 1935, 42: 769-72.------Resultats d'investigation de la temperature de 70,000 ecoliers de nos ecoles primaires. Congr. internat. med. scol, 1937, 1. Congr, 113.—Fraenkel, D. Leber die normale Korpertemperatur der Kinder und ihr Verhalten bei Bewegung und Ruhe. Deut med. Wschr.. 1913, 39: 267.—Konig, F. Hauttemperatur- messungen an Mannern von iiber 60 Jahren. Zschr. ges exp Med, 1939-40, 107: 98-105.— Laurel!. B. [The temperature of the grammar school children during school time] Duodecim Helsin, 1913, 29: 555-66.—Martsinkovski, B. I., & Zhorova', K. S. On the question of the distribution and regulation of heat in old age. Acta med. scand, 1936, 90: 582-92.—Pere- myslova, A. A. [Thermal regulation in young children] Pedi- atria, Moskva, 1940, No. 4, 7-10.—Robbin, L. A considera- tion of increased temperature variations in infants and children J. M. .Soc. N. Jersey, 1936, 33: 557-63.—Talbot, F. B. Skin temperatures of children. Am. J. Dis. Child, 1931 42- 965- 1052.—Vander Bogert, F., & Moravec, C. L. Body tempera- ture variations in apparentlv healthy children. J. Pediat S Louisv 1937, 10: 466-71.-Wolff, A. Ueber die Beeinflussung der Korpertemperatur im spiiten Kindesalter durch geringe Anstrengungen. Berl. khn. Wsehr, 1911, 48: 1760-2__ Zambrano, E. Le temperature cutanee nei bambini. Pediatria (Rit.) 1932, 40: 552-8.-Zhila. E. S. [Material for comparativ. physiology of thermoregulation; thermoregulation in new-born animals (rodents, predatory animals, primates)] J. Physiol USSR, 1940, 28: 335-12. ---- Variation: Diet, and metabolism. Benedict, F. G, & MacLeod, G. The heat production of the albino rat; technique, activity control, and the influence of fasting. J. Nutrit, 1928 29, 1: 343-66.—Dadlez, J, & Kos- kowski, W. [Research concerning peripheral temperature following ingestion of sugar or lactic acid] Polska gaz. lek 1926, 5: 703.—Fearing, F, & Ross. G. Behavior factor's affecting body temperature in pigeons; general level of activitv as modified bv deprivation and ingestion of food. J Comp.' Psychol, 1936, 22: 231-9.—Forbes. E. B, & Kriss, M. The analysis of the curve of heat production in relation to the plane of nutrition. J. Nutrit, 1932, 5: 183-97.—Fourcade. Les variations de temperature du nourrisson pendant la periode digestive. J. med. Paris, 1928, 47: 87-9.—Gudjonsson, S. V. The bodv temperature in rats on normal and deficient diets- preliminary report. J. Physiol, Lond, 1932, 74: 73-80.— Hasselbach, F. Vitamin C und Warmeregulation. Schweiz med. Wschr, 1937, 67: 877.—Hoffmann, R. Untersuchungen iiber die Warmeentwicklung von Ascaris lumbricoides bei Fiitterung mit Glukose, Fruktose und Galaktose. Zschr. Biol 1934, 95: 390-400.—Ito, S.T & Kosuge, T. The effect of intake of water and salt solution on the sweat secretion and on the regulation of body temperature. J. Orient. M, Dairen, 1935, 23: 8.—Kriss, M. The influence of the plane of nutrition on the manner of heat disposal by cattle. Am. J. Physiol, 1936, 116: 262-73.—Lee, It. C. The rectal temperature and the metabolism of the wild cottontail rabbit. J. Nutrit, 1940, 19: 173-7. Also repr.—busk, G. The influence of foodstuffs and their cleavage products upon heat production. Cornell Univ M. Bull, 1914, 4: 1-7.—Motta Coco, M. Influenza dei varii alimenti sulle oscillazioni nictemerali della temperatura. Atti Soc. itil. pat, 1900, 4: 320-2.—Raab. W. Warmeregulation und Fettstoffwechsel. Zschr. ges. exp. Med, 1926, 53: 317- 31.—Ringer, M, & Rapport, D. Animal calorimetry; the influence of the metabolism of the nucleic acids on heat produc- tion. J. Biol. Chem, 1923, 58: 475-82. ---- Variation: Environment. See also Acclimatization; Climate; Cold; Summer; Winter. Adolph. E. F. Heat exchanges of man in the desert. Am. J. Physiol, 1938, 123: 486-99.—Anderson, J. A. Effect of relative humidity on skin and rectal temperatures of the newborn infant. Proc. Soc. Exp. Biol, N. Y, 1940, 44: 466.— Ardashnikova, L. I, Vereshchagin, N. K. [et al] [Physiological manifestations in the adaptability of man to thermal influence] Sborn. Vsesoiuz. sezd. fiziol, 1937, 6. Congr, 317-21.— Auguet, A, & Lef&vre, J. Courbes de la d6perdition et du metabolisme, en fonction de la temperature exterieure, chez l'hom6otberme au repos. C. rend. Acad, sc, 1932, 194: 488- 91.—Bottner, H. Das Verhalten des Menschen in heisser Umgebung. Klin. Wschr, 1941, 20: 471-5.—Burton, A. C, Scott, J. C. [et al] Slow adaptations in the heat exchanges of man to changed climatic conditions. Am. J. Phvsiol, 1940, 129: 84-101—Cobet, R, von Haebler, T, & Parade, G. W. Beitrag zur Warmeregulation des Menschen bei Abkiihlung. Zschr. ges. exp. Med, 1930, 70: 739-59.—Cotte, J. Du role de l'etat actuel dans les reactions de l'homeotherme contre le froid. C. rend. Soc. biol, 1930, 103: 1027-9.—de Nieder- hausern, A. La termoregolazione alle basse temperature. Policlinico, 1939, 46: sez. prat, 314-36.—Dill, D. B.. Hall, F. G, & Edwards, H. T. Changes in composition of sweat during acclimatization to heat. Am. J. Physiol, 1938, 123: 412-9 — Egidi, E. La temperatura cutanea del lattante apiretico e febbricitante in rapporto con improvvisi sbalzi della tempera- tura ambiente. Pediat. med. prat. Tor, 1934, 9: 567-87.— Formicola, P. Variazioni termiche dell'organismo per modi- ficazioni locali della temperatura. Riv. pat. sper, 1928, 3: 101-11.—Gagge, A. P, Burton, A. C, & Bazett, H. C. A practical system of units for the description of the heat exchange of man with his environment. Science, 1941, 94: 428-30.— Gagge, A. P, Herrington, L. P., & Winslow, C. E. A. Thermal interchanges between the human body and its atmospheric environment. Am. J. Hyg, 1937, 26: 84-102.—Gelineo, S. Influence du milieu thermique d'adaptation sur la thermo- ginise des homeothermes. Ann. physiol. Par, 1934, 10: 1083-115. ----— Influence du milieu thermique d'adaptation sur la courbe de la thermoregulation. C. rend. Soc. biol, 1934, 117: 40-2.—Gessler, H, & Schaaff, G. Untersuchungen uber die Warmeregulation; die Warmeregulation bei Erwarmung. Arch. ges. Physiol, 1927, 216: 148-55.—Giaja, J, & Gelineo, 8. La thermogenese aux temperatures inferieures k celle de la resistance homeotherme. Ann. physiol. Par, 1931, 7: 152- 62.—Glekel, M. S. [Effect of overheating on the thermo- regulation and the cardio-vascular activitv in man] J. Physiol. USSR, 1936, 20: 611-23.—Goldby, F„ Hicks, C. S. [et al] A comparison of the skin temperature and skin circulation of naked whites and Australian aboriginals exposed to similar environmental changes. Austral. J. Exp. Biol, 1938, 16: 29-37.—Hardy, J. D, & Milhorat, A. T. Basal heat loss and production in women at temperatures from 23° C. to 36° C Proc. Soc. Exp. Biol, N. Y, 1939, 41: 94-8.------& Ou Bois, E. F. Basal metabolism and heat loss of young women at HEAT, ANIMAL 423 HEAT, ANIMAL temperatures from 22° C. to 35° C. J. *"«trit., 1941, 21: 383-404. Also In Temperature (Am. Inst. Physics N. Y, 1941 529-36.—Hicks, C. S, & O'Connor, W. J. Skin tem- perature of Australian aboriginals under varying atmospheric conditions. Austral. J. Exp. Biol, 1938, 16: 1-18. ----— The effect of changes of environmental temperature on the skin circulation of the naked Australian aboriginal, as measured bv the Sahli-Jaquet volumebolograph. Ibid, 19-28.—Hough- ten, F. C, & Teague, W. W. Body-temperature regulation and other physiological reactions in their relation to the physical characteristics of man's atmospheric environment. J. Am. Soc. Heat. Ventil Engin, 1928, 34: 873-85, ch.—Houghten, F. C, Teague, W. W. [et al] Thermal exchanges between the human body and its atmospheric environment. Am. J. Physiol, 1929, 88: 386-406.------Thermal exchanges between the bodies of men working and the atmospheric environment. Am. J. Hyg, 1931, 13: 415-31.—Kestner, O. Shortcomings of human heat-regulation in cold weather. Brit. J. Phys. M, 1942, 5: 33-8.—Koyama, T. Ueber Regulationsmechanismus der Korpertemperatur gegeniiber abweichender Umgebungstem- peratur. Jap. J. M. Sc, 1938, 11: Proc. Pharm, 14-6 — Kurshakov. N. A. [Heat interchange in normal men with a higher level of body .temperature] Izv. Imp. Voen. Med. Akad. S. Peterb, 1912, 24: 437-45.—Laurens, H. The effect of high temperature on body functions; the regulation of body tem- perature. N. Orleans M. & S. J, 1940-41, 93: 283-8— Lee, D H. K. The human organism and hot environments. Tr. R. Soc. Trop. M. Hyg, Lond, 1935-36, 29: 7-30.—Lehmann, Gl, & Szakall, A. Anpassungserscheinungen an Hitzearbeit. Arbeitsphysiologie, 1935-37, 9: 678-705.—Letavet. A. A, & Malysheva, A. E. [Investigation of the radiating heat exchange between man and his surrounding) Gig. & zdorov, 1941, 6: No. 4, 25-33.—McCance, R. A. Individual variations iii response to high temperatures and to the production of experimental salt deficiency. Lancet, Lond, 1938, 2: 190.— Margaria, R, & Talenti, C. Modificazione della temperatura dell'aria espirata, della temperatura interna e della ventilazione polmonare nella depressione barometrica. Arch, fisiol. Fir, 1930, 28: 114-27. Also Arch. ital. biol, 1930-31, 83: 46-52 — Marschak, M, & Dukeleky. O. Untersuchungen uber die Warmeregulation; uber die Wirkung hoher Umgebungstem- peraturen auf den physikalischen Zustand des Blutes und auf die Warmeregulation bei Menschen in Verbindung mit Wasser - und Kochsalzaufnahme. Arch. Hyg, Berl, 1929, 101: 325- 37.—Martin, C. J. Thermal adjustment of man and animals to external conditions. Lancet, Lond, 1930, 2: 561; 617; 673.—Mezincescu, M. D. L'effet de l'acclimatation aux temperatures eievees sur la composition de la sueur. C. rend. Soc. biol, 1937, 126: 540-2. ------ A phase of the problem of acclimatization to high temperatures. J. Indust. Hyg, 1937, 19: 146-51.—Nedzel, A. J. Temperature changes in trachea and kidney in relation to heat and cold on skin. Proc. Soc. Exp. Biol, N. Y, 1933, 30: 691.—Phelps, E. B, & Void, A. Studies in ventilation; skin temperature as related to atmos- pheric temperature and humidity. Am. J. Pub. Health, 1934, 24: 959-70.—Razgha, A, & Zselyonka, L. [The influence of various room temperatures on the temperature of the skin] Magy. orv. arch, 1940, 41: 512-8, tab.—Shik, L. L. [Thermo- regulation in man during work in various meteorological con- ditions) Gig. san, Moskva, 1939, 4: No. 12, 14-8.—Shoudy, L. A, &Baetjer, A. M. Heat and muscular work. Surg. Gyn. Obst, 1936, 62: 475-82.—Slonim, A. D, & Shcherbakova, O. P. [After-effect of high surrounding temperature on basal metabolism and body temperature; the so-called second chemical thermoregulation] J. Physiol. USSR, 1938, 25: 827-41.—Takabuchi, H. Determination of the comfort zone for Japanese and Manchurians; comfort zone for train-passen- gers in Manchuria in winter. J. Orient. M, Dairen, 1935, 22: 75.—Teding van Berkhoul, P. J. Etude sur la thermogenese des habitants des tropiques pendant la marche sur une surface horizontale. Meded. dienst. volksgez. Ned. Indie, 1929, 18: 71-80, 2 pl, 6 tab.—Thermal adjustment of man to external conditions. J. R. Army M. Corps, 1931, 56: 46-52—Wahl. R. Zur Regulation des Warmehaushalts in den Tropen. Arch. Schiffs Tropenhyg, 1929, 33: 42-5.—Wells, G. The effect of external temperature changes on heart rate, blood pressure, physical efficiency, respiration, and body temperature. Res. Q. Am. Phys. Educ. Ass, 1932, 3: 108-21. ------ The effect of external temperature changes on blood pressure, physical efficiency, respiration, and body temperature. Ibid, 1933, 4: 162-76.—Winslow, C. E. A. Man's heat exchanges with his thermal environment. In Temperature (Am. Inst. Physics) N. Y, 1941, 509-21.------& Gagge, A. P. Influence of physical work on physiological reactions to the thermal environ- ment. Am. J. Physiol, 1941, 134: 664-81.------& Herring- ton, L. P. Heat exchange and regulation ln radiant environ- ments above and below air temperature. Ibid, 1940-41, 131: 79-92.—Witz, H. E. Das Verhaltnis zwischen Korperent- warmung und Lungenentwarmung bei verschiedenen Luft- temperaturen und relativen Feuchtigkeitsgehalten. Fortsch. Med, 1935, 53: 273-5.—Yaglou, C. P. The comfort zone for men at rest and stripped to the waist. Tr. Am. Soc. Heat. Ventil. Engin, 1927, 33: 165-79. ---- Variation: Environment—in animals. Binet. L, & Morin, G. Accoutumance k la chaleur chez les poissons (Gobius lota) C. rend. Soc. biol, 1933, 114: 677-9. -----Action de la chaleur sur les poissons. J. physiol. path. gen, 1934 32- 372-9.—Bonnet, R, Influence des variations de la temperature exterieure sur la grandeur de Taction dynamique spetifique chez les poikilothermes. C. rend. Acad, sc 1995 181: 1092-4.—Bruhn, J. M. The heat production of a nonl heat regulating dog at various temperatures. Am. J. Physiol 1940, 129: 322.—Clarke, G. L, & Bonnet, D. D. The influence of temperature on the survival, growth and respiration of Calanus finmarchicus. Biol. Bull, 1939, 76: 371-83.—Cotte, J. Action des variations thermiques exterieures sur les pcecilo- thermes. C. rend. Soc. biol, 1930, 104: 1018-20.—Cowles, R. B. Possible implications of reptilian thermal tolerance. Science, 1939, 90: 465.—De Marco, R, & Imbesi. A. Azione dell'aria calda sulla glicemia e sulla temperatura corporea del Colombo. Bull. Soc. ital. biol. sper, 1934, 9: 30-2.—Doudoroff, P. Reactions of rriarine fishes to temperature gradients. Biol. Bull, 1938, 75: 494-509.—Gasnier, A, & Mayer, A. Reaction thermoregulatrice du lapin k des variations brusques et de faible amplitude de la temperature exterieure. Ann. phvsiol. Par, 1937, 13: 155-74.—Gelineo, S. La thermog6nese des oiseaux apres un sejour prolonge k diff6rentes temperatures. C. rend. Soc. biol, 1934, 116: 672-4.—Giaja, J, Chahovich, X, & Males, B. Sur l'abaissement de la temperature du rat et de la souris maintenus un certain temps k la neutralite thermi- que. Ibid, 1928, 98: 1155.—Gunn, D. L, & Notley, F. B. The temperature and humidity relations of the cockroach; thermal death-point. J. Exp. Biol, Lond, 1936, 13: 28-34.— Hemingway, A, & Barbour, H. G. The thermal tolerance of normal resting dogs as measured by changes of the acid base equilibrium and the dilution-concentration effect of plasma. Am. J. Physiol, 1938, 124: 264-70—Herrington, L. P. Tie heat regulation of small laboratorv animals at various environ- mental temperatures. Ibid, 1940, 129: 123-39.------ Heat production and thermal conductance in small laboratory animals at various temperatures. In Temperature (Am. Inst. Physics) N. Y, 1941, 446-52. Herter, K. Thermotaxis und Hydrotaxis bei Tieren. In Handb. norm. path. Physiol. (A. Bethe & G. Bergmann) Berl, 1926, 11: 173-80. ------ Die Beziehungen zwischen Vorzugstemperatur und Haut- beschaffenheit bei Mausen. Verh. Deut. Zool Ges, 1938, 40: 48-55.------Die Vorzugstemperaturen bei Landtieren. Naturwissenschaften, 1941, 29: 155-64.—Kalabukhov, N. I. Anabiose bei Wirbeltieren und Insekten bei Temperaturen unter 0° (zur Frage fiber die Unt Hmhlung und das Gefrieren der Tiere) Zool. Jahrb, Abt. allg. Zool, 1935, 55: 47-64.— Katd, M. The general consideration of the diurnal activity of the strawberry weevil, Anthonomus bisignifer Schenkling, with special reference to the body temperature of the weevil and the environmental temperature factors; diurnal rhythm of activities in insects and its environmental conditions. Sc. Rep. Tohoku Univ., 1940-41, 4. ser, 15: 179-89.—Kriiger, P, & Duspiva, F. Der Einfluss der Sonnenstrahlung auf die Lebensvorgange der- Poikilothermen. Biol, gen, Wien, 1932- 33, 9: 2. H, 168-88.—Lee, R. C. Heat production of the rabbit at 28° C; as affected by previous adaptation to temperatures between 10° and 31° C. J. Nutrit, 1942, 23: 83-90.—Males, B. Sulla temperatura degli eterotermi in rapporto alia tem- peratura dell'ambiente. Boll. Soc. ital. biol. sper, 1934, 9: 1223-6.—Mansbridge, G. H. Experiments on the resistance of the flour moth (Ephestia kuhniella Zell.) to abnormally high temperatures. Ann. Appl. Biol, Lond, 1936, 23: 803-21.— Margaria, R. Variazioni della temperatura nei conigli sotto- posti a depressione barometrica. Boll. Soc. ital. biol. sper, 1927, 2: 746-51.—Marshak, M. E. [Temperature changes in the interna! organs of the dog during warming and cooling of the animal in a chamber] Arkh. biol. nauk, 1939, 55: No. 3, 20-8.—Mayer, A, & Nichita, G. Sur une adaptation du lapin aux temperatures eievees. Ann. physiol. Par, 1929, 5: 609- 20.—Mazza, S. Observaciones de temperaturas en los mismos cobayos en diferentes continentes apreciadas con el nusino term6metro. Rev. Soc. argent, biol, 1925, 1: 719r22.— Mellanby, K. Temperature acclimatization in amphibia. J. Physiol, Lond, 1940, 98: Suppl, 27.—Nashivanenko, T. T. Rhythmic variations of the sensitivity of organisms to high, temperature and temperature adaptation. Bull, biol med. exp. URSS, 1938, 6: 71-4—Ogle, C, & Mills. C. A. Animal adaptation to environmental temperature conditions. Am. J. Physiol, 1933, 103: 606-12— Rouse, E. T., & Cristenson, R. O. A simple apparatus for the determination of thermal death points. Tr. Am. Micr. Soc, 1940, 69: 275-8. Schuhecker, K. Untersuchungen uber die Warmeregulation der Ziege bei hoherer Aussentemperatur im Vergleich zu der kleiner Nager und der Katze. Arch. ges. Physiol, 1936-37, 238: 665-83.- Sharovatova, S. F. A contribution to the mechanismof adaptation of the organism to high temperature. Bull biol. med. exp. URSS, 1938-39, 6: 671-4.—Shcherbakov, A. P. [Span of life an J metabolism of Drosophila melanogaster in various temperatures] Biol. J, Moskva, 1933 2: 82-8.— Sheard, C, Rynearson, E. H, & McK. Craig, W. Effects of environmental temperature, anesthesia and lumbar sympathetic ganglionectomy on the temperatures of the extremities of animals. J. Clin. Invest, 1932, 11: 183r93 -Shevchenko, A. T [Peculiarities of thermometry of animals in central Asia] Sovet vet, 1939, 16: No. 9, 85— Slonim, A. D. [Physiology of thermoregulation in tropical and mountain animals (primates and carnivorous)] J. Physiol USSR, 1937, 22. 89-99. [Temperature of habitation and heat regulation in the organism of mammalsL Usp. sovrem. biol, 1941, 14: 52-60.— Tohang Si. Resistance aux variations de temperature chez quelques animaux marins. C. rend. Soc biol, 1934 116: 10o6.- Weigmann. R. Zur Kaltebestiindigkeit poikilothermer Tiere, HEAT, ANIMAL 424 HEAT, ANIMAL Untersuchung an Schnecken und Fischen. Biol. Zbl, 1936, 56: 301-22.—Wells, N. A. Change hi rate of respiratory metabolism in a telcost fish induced bv acclimatization to high and low temperature. Biol. Bull, 1935, 69: 361-7.—Whitney, R. J. The thermal resistance of mayfly nymphs from ponds and streams. J. Exp. Biol, Lond, 1939, 16: 374-85. ---- Variation: Experimental conditions. Antoshkina, E. D. [Thermoregulation following heat puncture] J. Physiol USSR, 1940, 28: 256-63.—Barbour, H. G. Die Wirkung unmittelbarer Erwarmung und Abkiihlung der Warmezentra auf die Korpertemperatur. Arch. exp. Path, Lpz, 1912, 70: 1-26.—Castex, M. R.; & Ontaneda, L. E. Centros vegetativos termorreguladores; efectos de la puncion cisternal sobre la temperatura corporal. Prensa med. argent, 1930-31, 17:1093-106, pl—Clark, G. Temperature regulation in chronic cervical cats. Am. J. Physiol, 1940, 130: 712-22.— Gianni, E., & Sacchi, U. L'influenza della ipertensione endo- crinica sperimentale sulla termoregolazione. Fisiol. & med, Roma, 1935, 6: 235-48.—Gordon, A. The relation of with- drawal of cerebrospinal fluid to the body temperature; con- sideration of a thermoregulatory center; a study of 250 cases. Arch. Int. M, 1929, 44: 263-71.—Hemingway, A., Rasmussen, T. [et al] Effect of cutting the pituitary stalk on physiological temperature regulation. Endocrinology, 1940, 27: 212-8.— Hermann, H, Jourdan, F. [et al] Conservation de reactions thermoregulatrices chez le chien k moelle detruite bistellecto- mise, puis bivagotomise. C. rend. Soc. biol, 1939, 132: 11.— Hermann, H., Morin, G, & Galy, P. Efficacite de la thermo- regulation au cours du refroidissement chez le chien sans moelle. Ibid, 1938, 127: 1491-3.—Hill, L. Effects of partial obstruc- tion of the air ways of the lungs and the influence of sources of heat. J. Hyg, Cambr, 1936, 36: 602-8.—Kimura, T. Ver- halten des Warmecentrums von Wiirmeregulationscentren im engeren Sinne zur Erhaltung von Korpertemperatur beim auf Ruckenlage befestigten Kaninchen. Jap. J. M. Sc, 1940, 13: Proc. Pharm, 69.—Kurotsu, T, & Megawa, N. Weitere Mitteilungen iiber den Kuhlstich. Ibid, 1941, 9: Proc. Anat, 67.—Lucena, J., & Benicio, A. Variacoes de temperatura imediatamente consecutivas k retirada do lfquido cefalo- raquiano. Neurobiologia, Recife, 1941, 4: 213-24.—Magoun, H. W. Activation of mechanisms for heat loss by local heating of the brain. Arch. Neur. Psychiat, Chic, 1938, 40: 404 — Morais, E. Modifications de la temperature consecutives a, la tesection du ganglion cervical du sympathique chez le lapin. C. rend. Soc. biol, 1932, 109: 483.—Pinkston, J. O, Bard, P, & Rioch, D. Mck. The responses to changes in environmental temperature after removal of portions of the forebrain. Am. J. Physiol, 1934, 109: 515-31.—Putchkov, N. V. [Artificial lowering of body temperature in mammals] J. eksp. biol, 1930, 13: 5-8.—Rakieten, N. Changes in heat production after removal of motor and premotor areas in monkeys. Am. J. Physiol, 1935-36, 114: 661-6.—Sawyer, M. E. M, & Schlossberg, T. Studies of homeostasis in normal, sympathec- tomized and ergotaminized animals; the effect of high and low temperatures. Ibid, 1933, 104: 172-83. ------ Studi sull omeostasi (homeostasis in animali senza sistema simpatico) Sunti Congr. internaz. fisiol, 1932, 14. Congr, 226-7.— Spinelli, A. Remarques sur l'influence du travail musculaire et du massage sur le comportement de l'hyperthermie experi- mentale du lapin. Arch. ital. biol, 1934-35, 92: 123-33.— Thauer, R, & Peters, G. Warmeregulation nach operativer Ausschaltung des Warmezentrums. Arch. ges. Physiol, 1937, 239: 483-514.—Tyslowitz, R, & Astwood, E. B. The effect of corticotrophin on the resistance of hypophysectomized rats to low environmental temperatures. Am. J. Physiol, 1941, 133: 472.—Zollinger, R., & Schnitker, M. T. Skin temperature reactions following removal of the left cerebral hemisphere. Science, 1934, 79: 540. Variation: Mental influence. Fearing, F, & Ross, G. Behavior factors affecting body temperature in pigeons; general level of activity as modified by anesthesia and visual controls. J. Comp. Psychol, 1936 22: 219-30.—Gessler, H, & Hansen, K. Ueber die suggestive Beeinflussbarkeit der Warmeregulation in der Hypnose Deut Arch. klin. Med, 1927, 156: 352-9. Also Verh. Deut Ges' inn. Med, 1927, 39. Kongr, 86. Also Zbl. inn. Med 1927 48: 658.—Mittelmann, B, & Wolff, H. G. Affective states'and skin temperature; experimental study of subjects with cold hands and Raynaud's syndrome. Psychosomat. M 1939 1 • 271-92.—Takada, R. Mental influence on the body'tempera- ture of healthy workers. Bull. Nav. M. Ass, Tokyo 1937 26: No. 3, 3.—Zelenin, V. F., Kannabikh, I. V. [et al] '[Effect of the mental factor on the mechanism of thermoregulation and on certain forms of metabolism] Klin, med., Moskva 1936 14: 973—82. ---- Variation, occupational. H*?N7> L- *Messungen der Korpertempera- turen bei Sporttreibenden. 47p. 22^cm. Borna- Lpz., 1939. »t u?/^ J" &. A3BI,f*' A- J^s courbes thermoregulatrices et les rendements de la machine vivante dans les grandes puissances de travail. Ann. physiol. Par, 1934,10:1116-34 — Miyagi, T. Observation concerning normal body temperature of sailors. Bull. Nav. M. Ass, Tokyo, 1937, 26: No. 3, 1.— Schnyder, W. F. Die Korpertemperatur der Ofenarbeiter tines Eisenwalzwerkes. Arch. Ophth, Berl, 1933-34, 131- 611-3. ---- Variation, periodical. Petersen, G. A. *Beitrag zur 24-Stunden- Rhythmik der Korpertemperatur beim Menschen 9p. 8? Greifsw., 1935. Breyer, J. Ueber die auffallende Uebereinstimmung im Verlauf der Tagesschwankungen der Sauglings- beziehungs- weise Kindersterblichkeit und der kindlichen Korpertempera- tur. Arch. Kinderh, 1937, 112: 34-40.—Brouwer, E. Har- monische Analyse von Temperaturkurven. Acta brevia neerl 1931, 1: 31-3.— Burckhard, E., & Kayser, C. De l'origine de rythine nycthemeral C. rend. Soc. biol, 1932, 109: 1281-3. ----— & Dontcheff, L. Le rythme nycthemeral chez le pigeon" Ann. physiol. Par, 1933, 9:303-68.—Dontcheff, L, Kayser, C, & Reiss, P. Le rythme nycthemeral de la production de chaleur chez le pigeon et ses rapports avec l'excita- bilite des centres thermotegulateurs. Ann. physiol. Par, 1935, 11: 1185-208.—Frisch, K. Zur Frage des Tempera- turansteigens im Winter. Acta Univ. Tartu, 1928, 13: A, No. 7, 1-11.—Heiser, F, & Cohen, L. H. Diurnal variations of skin temperature. J. Indust. Hyg, 1933, 15: 243-54.—Kato, M. Diurnal variation in the body temperature of the strawberry weevil, Anthonomus bisignifer Schenkling; the diurnal rhythm of activities in insects and its environmental conditions. Sc. Rep. Tohoku Univ., 1940-41, 4. ser, 15: 97-103.—Kleitman, N, Titelbaum, S, & Feiveson, P. Diurnal variation in reaction time and its relation to body temperature. Am. J. Physiol, 1935, 113: 82.—Kleitman, N, Titelbaum, S, & Hoffmann, H. The establishment of the diurnal temperature cycle. Ibid, 1937, 119: 48-54.—Liese, W. Ueber den jahreszeitlichen Gang der Stirntemperatur und ihre Bedeutung fiir die objektive Behaglichkeitbeurteilung. Ge- sundh. Ingenieur, 1939, 62: 345-50.—Osborne, W. A. Body temperature and periodicity. Proc. Physiol. Soc, Lond, 1907-8, p. xxxix-xli.—Pla i Armengol, R. Contribucio l'estudi de l'evoluci6 diaria de la temperatura en l'home ak i en qualques malalts. An. Acad. lab. cienc. med. Catalunya, 1913, 7: 353-416.—Roumaillac, J. L. Reflexions sur la courbe de temperature. J. med. Bordeaux, 1933, 110: 499-505.— Rudder, B. de, & Petersen, G. A. Zur Tagesperiodik der Korpertemperatur beim Menschen. Klin. Wschr, 1935, 14: 1814-6.—Scheurer, O, & Zimmermann, H. Sind die Haut- temperaturen von Mann und Frau verschieden, besteht ein Unterschied zwischen Tag und Nacht? Zschr. ges. exp. Med, 1936-37, 100: 417-26.—Slonim, A. D., & Bezuevskaia, R. A. [Seasonal changes of thermoregulation] J. Physiol. USSR, 1940, 28: 330-4. ---- Variation, physiological. Benedict, F. G., Fox, E. L., & Coropatchinsky, V. The incubating python: a temperature study. Proc. Nat. Acad. Sc. U. S, 1932, 18: 209-12. Also repr.—Fabre, R., & Hiri- berry, H. Variations physiologiques de la temperature hu- maine. C. rend. Soc. biol, 1935, 118: 701-3. Also J. med. Bordeaux, 1935, 112: 531-3.—Hewitt, E. A. Effect of service upon temperatures in cattle. J. Am. Vet. M. Ass, 1924-25, 65: 724-31.—Mohr & Seele. Ueber den Einfluss der Arbeits- leistung auf die Korpertemperatur und den Puis bei Truppen- pferden. Zschr. Veteriniirk, 1937, 49: 337-51.—Roth, G. M, Williams, M. M. D, & Sheard, C. Changes in the skin tem- peratures of the extremities produced by changes in posture. Am. J. Physiol, 1938, 124: 161-7.—Traina Rao, G. Ricerche termo-elettriche nei campo ostetrico e ginecologico. Riv. ital. gin, 1934-35, 17: 117-90. HEAT-CRAMPS. See also Heat, Pathology. Eaton, W. E. Treatment and prevention of heat cramps. U. S. Nav. M. Bull, 1933, 31: 162-4.—Glover, D. M. Haat cramps in industry: their treatment and prevention by means of sodium chloride. J. Indust. Hyg, 1931, 13: 347-60.— Hatcher, H. C. Heat cramps. Med. Bull. (Standard Oil Co,) N. Y, 1936-38, 3: 30-4.—Heat cramps. Ann. Int. M, 1936-37, 10: 270-3.—Kofoed, S. E. [Fireman's cramp] Ugeskr. laegar. 1935, 97: 1066-8.—Starkov, P. M, & Vikesh, J. V. Heat cramps and heat prostration in hot industries. J. Indust. Hyg, 1935, 17: 247-52.—Talbott, J. H. Heat cramps. Medi- cine, Bait, 1935, 14: 323-76. ------& Michelsen, J. Heat cramps; a clinical and chemical study. J. Clin. Invest, 1933, 12: 533-49. HEAT-EXHAUSTION. See Heatstroke. HEATH, Arthur Douglas, -1936. Obituary. Brit. M. J, 1937, 1: 1286. HEATH, Charles Joseph, 1856-1934. Diag- nosis and treatment in. cases of otitis media (mastoid disease) a paper read before the HEATH 425 HEATING Hunterian Society, London, rev. and amplified by the addition of numerous notes and illustra- tions explanatory of the indications for the performance of the author's conservative mastoid operation. 61 [l]p. illust. ch. 22cm. Lond., Bailliere, Tindall & Cox, 1919. For biography see Brit. M. J, 1934, 2: 235. Also J. Am. M. Ass, 1934, 103: 690. Also S. Barth. Hosp. J, Lond, 1934, 42:3. HEATH, Christopher, 1835-1905. Minor surgery and bandaging (Heath, Pollard) for the use of house surgeons, dressers and junior practitioners. 16. ed., by H. Morriston Davies. x, 476p. illust. front. 19cm. Lond., J. & A. Churchill, 1917. Also 17. ed. viii, 447p. illust. 1920. HEATH, D. C, & Co. See Mansion, J. E. Heath's standard French and English dictionary. 2v. 29cm. Bost, 1934. HEATH, Esther. A study in social treatment; the approach to the parent. 4 p. 1.; xviii, 163p. 8? N. Y., Commonwealth Fund, 1933. HEATH, Harold, 1868- See Burlingame, Leonas Lancelot. Heath. H. [et al.] Gen- eral biology. 2v. 568p.;597p. 8! N. V, 1923-28. HEATH, Sir H[enry] Frank, 1863- Editor of Yearbook (The) of the universities of the Empire. 3v. 8° Lond, 1930-31; 1933. HEATH, James Proctor. See Horsburgh, David B, & Heath, James P. Atlas of cat anatomy. 39 1. 4° Stanford Univ., Calif. [1938] HEATH, Sir Thomas [Little] 1861- Archi- medes. 2 1. 58p. 12? N. Y., Macmillan co., 1920. In Pioneers of progress; men of science (Chapman, S.) HEATHENISM. See God; Paganism; Religion. HEATHERLEY, Francis. Modern methods in the diagnosis and treatment of heart disease. 2. ed. xii, 269p. 8? Lond., Bailliere, Tindall & Cox, 1926. HEATING. See also Baking; Cooking; Gas heating; Heating industry. Allen, J. R., & Walker, J. H. Heating and air conditioning. 5. ed., 2. impression. 593p. 23^cm. N. Y., 1939. Bedford, T. Requirements for satisfactory ventilation and heating. 12p. 8? [Lond., 1936] ---- Modern principles of ventilation and heating. 85p. 8? Lond., 1937. Dalzell, J. R., & Hubbard, C. L. Air con- ditioning, heating and ventilating. 571p. 21^cm. Chic, 1939. Faber, O., & Kell, J. R. Heating and air- conditioning of buildings; with some notes on combined electrical generating stations. 434p. 8? Lond., 1936. Greene, A. M. Principles of heating, ventilat- ing and air conditioning. 446p. 8? N. Y., 1936. Rietschel, H. I. Leitfaden der Heiz- und Liiftungstechnik. 7. Aufl. von K. Brabbee. 2v. 182p.; 182p. 4? Berl., 1925. Severns, W. H. Heating, ventilating, and air conditioning fundamentals. 467p. 8? N. Y., 1937. A. Bekanntmachung iiber die Beheizung der Dienstraume. Gesundh. Ingenieur, 1926, 49: 199.—Dufford, R. T. Heating problems. Science Leaflet, 1940-41, 14: 986-8.—Govan, J. Some observations on heating practice. Tr. Am. Soc. Heat. Ventil. Engin, 1933, 39: 63-74.—Grober, H. Entwicklungs- moglichkeiten fiir die Heizung in Stadten. Gesundh. Ingenieur, 1927, 50: 966-8.—Ivanov, E. M. [On supplying heat on streets for cabmen, workers, policemen, etc.] Mosk. med. J, 1926, 6: No. 5, 87-91.—Schulz, B. Heizsysteme der Ge- genwart Umschau, 1929, 33: 25-8.—Vernon, H. M. Some 287-90 heatlne buildings. J. Indust. Hyg, 1930, 12: ---- Air conditioning. See also Air, Moisture and temperature; Air, Purification; Ventilation. . Pantillon, P. *Chauffage central et dessica- tion de Fair au point de vue de l'hygiene des habitations [Lausanne] 19p. 8? Neuchatel, Schmidhuber, B. *Luftbefeuchtung in Wohn- zimmern [Tubingen] 22p. 8? Miinch., 1932. Stephan, A. *L'humidification de l'atmos- phere dans les habitations. 62p. 8? Par., 1931. De Fermo, V, & Tecce, R. Umidita delle abitazioni. Ann. igiene, 1935, 45: 389-98.—Gonzenbach, W. von. Die Be- deutung der Kondensationskerne fur das Trockenheitsgefuhl in geheizten Raumen. Schweiz. med. Wschr, 1941, 71: 1397.—Graefe, E. Macht dieZentralheizung die Luft trocken9 Umschau, 1935, 39: 141-3.—Habs, H. Experimentelle Unter- suchungen iiber die hygienische Wirksamkeit von Luftbe- feuchtungsanlagen. Gesundh. Ingenieur, 1930, 53: 593-6.— Heller, A. Feuerungsanlagen und Luftbeschaffenheit. Ibid, 1937, 60: 385-90.—Hirsch, M. Die Abkiihlung feuchter Luft. Ibid, 1926, 49: 376-9.—Lewis, S. R. Air supply, distribution and exhaust systems. Tr. Am. Soc. Heat. Ventil. Engin, 1933, 39: 139-48.—Nouaille, R. Les perfectionnements apportes au chauffage et a la ventilation des locaux; le condi- tionnement de Fair. Techn. san. mun. Par, 1933, 28: 310-5.— Watzinger, A. Frischluftzufuhr hinter geschlossenen Heiz- korpern. Gesundh. Ingenieur, 1938, 61: 493; 513. ---- Automatic control. Hanel, O. Automatische Oelfeuerung fur Zentralheizungs- kessel. Gesundh. Ingenieur, 1929, 52: 609-12.—Konzo, S, & Hubbard, A. F. Automatic controls for forced-air heating systems. Tr. Am. Soc. Heat. Ventil. Engin, 1934, 40: 37-54.— Lang, A. Diirfen Oelfeuerungssysteme ohne vollautomatische Regulierung fur Zentralheizungen Verwendung finden? Ge- sundh. Ingenieur, 1929, 52: 801-3.—Lang, M. Theorie und Technik der selbsttatigen Regelung von Warmesystemen. Ibid, 1935, 58: 317-23.—Linden, A. J. ter. Feuerungstech- nische Untersuchungen mit selbsttatigem Kohlenstoker und Oelbrenner fiir Sammel-Heizungskessel Ibid, 1936, 59: 653-7.—Pohl, M. von. Selbsttiitige Verbraucheranschliisse in Heiznetzen. Ibid, 1941, 64: 63.—Ritter, P. Die selbsttiitige , Regelung von Sammelheizungsanlagen. Ibid, 1938, 61: 619-21.—Schellhase, C. Selbsttiitige Temperatur-Regelung in der neuen Reichskanzlei. Ibid, 1939, 62: 541-4. ---- Boiler, burner, heater, and stoker. See also subheadings Radiator; Stove. Angus, R. W. How air turbulence influences efficiency of hot blast heaters. J. Am. Soc. Heat. Ventil. Engin, 1927, 33: 405-14.—Barkow, H. Aluminium oder Reinnickel? Zschr. ges. Krankenhauswes, 1926, 22: 139-41.—Beck, P. Der Kessel-Wirkungsgrad in der Heizungsindustrie. Gesundh. Ingenieur, 1929, 52: 148-50.—Bertheau. Die neuen Werkstoff- und Bauvorschriften fiir Landdampfkessel Arbeiterschutz, 1926, 2: 153-7.—Dalzell, J. R, & Hubbard, C. L. Boilers. In their Air Condit, Chic, 1939, 69-102.—Grahl, de. Kritik an Heizkesselversuchen. Gesundh. Ingenieur, 1929, 52: 433-6.—Herody, C. Conduits de fumrJe et appareils de chauffage. Techn. san. mun. Par, 1939, 31: 17-26.—Kiistner, W. Heizversuche an einem gusseisernen Gliederkessel bei natiirlicher und kunstlicher Verbrennungsluftzufuhr. Gesundh. Ingenieur, 1929, 52: 304-8.—Mcllvaine, J. H. Application of oil burners to various types of domestic heating systems. Tr. Am. Soc. Heat. Ventil. Engin, 1929, 35: 195-210 — Ritter, P. Aus der Heizungstechnik im auslandischen Patent- schrifttum. Gesundh. Ingenieur, 1939, 62: 208-10. ------ Aus dem Heizungsgebiet im Patentwesen. Ibid, 1941r 64: 91.—Rohr, F. Die Hochleistungsheizflache von Dampf- und Warmwasserkesseln. Ibid, 1926, 49: 119.—Trumper, C. Gusseiserner Zentralheizungskessel mit allseitig den Feuerraum und die Heizgasziige umgebenden wasserberiihrten Heiz- flachen. Ibid, 350.—Uhlmann, J. Gusseiserne Gross-Roh- braunkohlengliederkessel fiir Zentralheizungen. Ibid, 773.— Watt, O. G. Heating apparatus. U. S. Patent Off, 1939, No. 2,175,329.—Z. Heizvorrichtung fiir Lagerbehalter der Oelfeuerungen und Sicherung zum Schutze derselben gegen Feuer und Zerknall. Zschr. Gewerbehyg, 1935, 42: 164-7. ---- Building construction. See also Chimney. Baltrusch. Der Warmeschutz beim Stahlhaus. Gesundh. Ingenieur, 1928, 51: 83.—Cammerer. J. S. Der Warmeschutz von organischen Baustoffen unter den praktischen Verhalt- nissen. Ibid, 1936, 59: 261-8.—Giovannini, G. Die warme- technischen Einrichtungen der Wohnhaussiedlung Neudorf. Ibid, 1930, 53: 1-8.—Jungbluth, M. Einiges zur Werkstof- frage im Heizungs- und Luftungsbau. Ibid, 1939, 62: 85. ------& Linden, A. J. ter. Schornstein- und Luftungsaufsatze, HE ATI Mi 42(i HEATIN(; Ibid, 221 5.—Meier, K. Die Heizunasfrace im Wohnungsbau. Ibid, 19L'i. 49: 177-80. -Mejstrik. J. Das Hradtagverfahren und seine Anwendung fiir Bauwesen und I leizindustrie in der ehemaligen Tschechoslowakischen Itepubhl uml im Sudeten- lande. Ibid.. 1039, 62: 561; 573- Meuth. H. Lutersucluiigen iiber den Einfluss haulicher Mangel auf den Kaminzug. Ibid, 1938. 61: 575-9.—Reiner, H. Heizung und Schallschutz. Ibid, 1927. 50: 699-701. ---- Central and district plants. Czernichow, H. *Les inoonvdnicnts du chauffage central et les moyens d'v rcmedicr. 48p. 8? Par., 1933. B. A. Die deutschen offentlichen Fernheizwerke. Gesundh. Ingenieur. 1938. 61: 758.—Boileau, C. Production centralist par voie de thermo-compression et distributions publiques de chaleur et de froid dans les villes notamment du bassin de la Mediterranee. Atti Congr. internaz. teen, san, 1931, 2. Congr, 3: 355-61. pl—Bormann, K. Die Siadtheizung von Villeur banne. Gesundh. Ingenieur, 1935, 58: 745 -8.—Kauffmann, K. Zentralheizung mit Warmczahlern. Lmschau, 1926, 30: 85-1.—Krob, E. Ist eine Fernheizung rentabel? Gesundh. Ingenieur, 1929, 52: 102 -8.—Kuhberg. Fern- und Stadte- leizung. Umschau, 1920, 30: 852-4.—Ludwig. Stiidtische Fernheizwerke. Gesundh. Ingenieur, 1928, 51: 518-20.— Marx, A. Die Einwirkung der Zentralheizung auf Holzge- genst.-inde. Ibid, 1930. 53: 129-31.—Maximilian. E. F. Lie Probeheizungen von Sammelheizungsa.nl agon. Ibid, 1938, 61: 421; 442.—Montrose-Oster. Grosskraftwerk oder Block- station? Ibid, 1928. 51: 194-6.—Nussbaum, H. C. Liisst eine der Fernheizungsformen sich gegenwartig bereits allge- mein durchfuhren? Techn. Gemciudebl, 1926-27, 29: 234-0.— Pohl, K. A. Die Entwicklung des Fernhcizwe.sons in Russland. Gesundh. Ingenieur, 1935. 5M: 101-8. --- Erfahrungen bei der Verlegung von russisehen IVrnleizleitungen. Ibid, 193S, 61: 498.-----■ Aiuschliisse der Hansheizungen an die lernbeiznetze. Ibid, 773.—Schereschewsky, M. Le chauffage urbaiu des villes considtfte au point de vue sanitaire; suppression des funnies domestiques nocives; distribution d'eau chaude; hyeiene du foyer. Techn. san. mun. Par, 1933, 28: 56--6L— Squassi. F. II nsealdamento di zone urbane. Atti Congr. mieinaz. teen, san, 1931, 2. Congr, 3: 335—18.—Thum. Die I ernlieizanlage fur die staatlichen Museen auf der Muse unisinsel in Merlin. Gesundh. Ingenieur, 1935, 58: 382-9.— Trollor, A. La distribution centrale de la chaleur k Paris. Nature. Par, 1928, 56: 103 6— Walensky, B. Die Heizuiurs- anlage in der Vatikanisclien Stadt. Gesundh. Ingenieur, 1934, 57: 137.—Wier/. Kirchenheizungen. Ibid, 1935, 58: 593-5.— Wolf, G. Einsparuiig von Eisen bei Zentralheizungen. Ibid, 1938. 61: 409. Der Schornstein fiir die Zentralheizung. Ibid, 477-80.- Zimmermann, W. Wahlweise mit Warm- wass.i und Niederdnn-kdampf zu betreihender Heizungsanlage (Doppel/i ntial-IIeizungssvstem) Ibid, 1926, 49: 218 20. ---- Corrosion of apparatus. Balcke, H. Massnahmen zur Verhiitung von Gaszerstorun- gen in Heizungs- und Warmwasserbereitiingsanlagen. Ge- sundh. Ingenieur, 192S. 51: 449-52.------Angewandte Korrosionsforschung fur die Heizungsindustrie. Ibid, 1929, 52: 49-53. Groeck, M. Die Verhiitung von Kesselstein und Host in heissem Wasser. Ibid, 1926, 49: 740-2. ------ Anode unci Kathode im Korrosionsi lenient. Ibid, 1929. 52: 53 8. Gunnewig, F, & Trapp, K. Korrosionserschciuungen an Waimwasserbereitern. Ibid, 19X8, 61: 687-90.- -Haase, I,. W. Koi rosions- und Werkstoffi agen auf dem Gebiete des Warmwassers und der Heizung. Hid, 1939, 62: 86-95.— Zurlinden, H. Korrosionen. Techn. Gemeindebl, 1926-27, 29: 222-5. ---- Danger, and safety. Balcke, H. Massnahmen zur dauernden Verhiitung von Steinansatz in Heizungs- und Warmwasserbereitungsanlagen. Gesundh. Ingenieur, 1928, 51: 385-90.—Bleyert, W. Kessel- stein in Zentralheizungskesseln. Ibid, 1929. 52: 58-61.— Fischer, F. Frostschaden an dreitausend Heizungsanlagen. Ibid, 1941, 64: 231.—Hauck, K. Schaden an dampfgeheizten Trockenzylindern. Zbl. Gewerbehyg, 1927, u. F, 4: 399.— Koch, H. Frischdampfverteibmg in Hochdiuekke selanlagen unter besonderer Beriicksichtigung der Liilillverhiitung Arbeiterschutz, 1929, 90-2.—Koritnig, O. T. Die Gefahren der Dampfkesselreinignng und deren Verhiitung. Zschr Gewerbehyg, 1926, 32: 134-6.— Remund. M. H. Die Reini- gung der Zentralheizungsanlagen und ihre Gefahren. Schweiz med. Wschr, 1929, 59: 747-51.—Robse, H. Sind die preus- sischen Sicherheits-Vorschriften fur Heizkessel mangelhaft und tcilweiie unhaltbar? Gesundh. Ingenieur, 1928, 51: 729.— Sichcrheitsvorrichtungen fiir offene und geschlossene Wasser- leizuugeu. Ibid, 19 11. 64: 257-60.—Stiegler, L. Sicherheits- vorschriften fiir \\ annwasserheizkessel Ibid, 1937. 60: 129-31.—Voces. Der Kesselstein und seine Bekampfung Zschr. ges. Krankenhauswes, 1926, 22: Hl-5. ---- Description of large plants. Derigs. F. Vereinigte Pumpenwarmwassor- und Luft- heizung fur Horsale; Hcizung und Luftung beim Neubau des Miinchener Zoologiscbcn und Hol.uiiselen I'niversitats- Institutcs. Gesundh. Ingenieur, 1'•:{.">. r>N: 773 9.- Dorcnhcrg, ('. Die Heizungs- und Liiftungsanlagen in den Einpfaiur.sgp. biiuden der Bnhnhofe Duisburg und Oberhausen. Ibid, 1934, 57: 651-6. (■runow, W. Die Heizung und Luftung der Jahrhundertlialle in Breslau Ibid, 1938. 61: 560-4.- Hert- weck, R. Die llehtizung des Volkerbund-I'alastes in Genf. Ibid, 703; 717.—Hofmann, H. Kraft- und Warmezentrale in der Hebammenlehranstaltiii lleerlen. Ibid, 1926, 49: 181-8.— Holliger. P. P.. Die hoizungs-, luftungs- und gesundhcits- leeliniselien Anlagen ira neuen Bankgebiiudc der Nederlindschc Handel Miatscbappij, Amsterdam. Ibid, 1927. 50: 6S6 -90.— Hottinger, M. Die Fernheizung im Kloster Fngellnrg. Ibid, I92S, 51: 545-50.—-Hiittner. Neuerung auf dem 1 leizungsiie- biet im Krankenhaus. Zschr. ges. Krankenhauswes, 1934, -11 7 -9. hiissniaiin, A. Dis Heizungs-. Luftungs- und sonstigen teehniselen Anlagen der Horst-Wossol-Schulo (Knabenberufs- scbule) Dresden und ihre Bedeutung fiir den AnschauuriRs- unteiriebl. Gesundh. Ingenieur, 1935, 58: 633-7.—Ohmes, A. K. Ueber nordamerikanischc Heizungs- und Luftungs- lechnik. Ibid, 1927, 50: 682-6.-Petersen. Die Heizungs- und Liiftungsanlaiige der Hochschule fiir Lehrerbildung in Frankfurt (Oder) Ibid, 1936. 59: 113-8.—Pukowski, K, & I'ronhbfer. G. Die Heizungs- und Liiftiingsanlage im Staats- t beater Danzig. Ibid, 577-83.—Reschke. Die Dresdner Stadtheizung. Ibid, 1935, 58: 261-7.—Rheineck, K. Das Heizkraftwerk Barmen. Ibid, 1926, 49: 469-75.—Rublic, H. Die Heizungs-und Liiftiingsanlage im Neubau des Verwaltungs- gebiiudes der Skodawerke in Prag. Ibid, 1927, 50: 879-84— Ruegg, F. Die Heisswasserubertragungsaiilage des Fern- heizkraflwerkes in Zurich fiir die Wiiruiebelieferung von Glossal.nehmein. Ibid, 1935, 58: 729 36..--Sageblil, H. Die Heizungs- und Liiftungsanligen des neuen Lniversitiits gebiiudes in Koln. Ibid, 521-6. Taubcrl, A. Die Heizungs- und Liiftungsanlase der Staatsoner Cuter den Linden in Berlin und ihre Bcv/iihrung. Ibid, 403-11. —— domestic. Arnoldt. Heizung, Warmwasser-, Luft-, Gas-, Was.ser- und Stromversorgung der neuen Klein- und Mittelwohnung und ihre Wirtschaftlichkeit. Gesundh. Ingenieur, 1928, 51: 353; 370.—Bahls, A. Die Stockwerkszentrallieizungen in Mehr- familienhausern. Umschau, 1926, 30: 855-7.- Beck, P. Heizung, Warmwasser-, Luft-, Gas-, Wasser- und Stromver- sorgung der neuen Klein- und Mittelwohnung und ihre Wirt- schaftlichkeit. Gesundh. Ingenieur, 1928, 51: 633-6.— Heating equipment in the home. Travelers Stand, 1940, 28: 197-200.—Hn. Der Mindestwiirmeschutz im landlichen Wohn- und Sfallbau. Gesundh. Ingenieur, 1939, 62: 622.— Mangold, H. Heizung und Luftung der Wohnung. Umschau, 1927, 31: 927-32.—Raiss. W. Untersuchungen uber die Wirlschaftlichkeit zentraler Heizanligen in Wohnungsbauten. Gesundh. Ingenieur, 1934, 57: 473 80. Scholtz, W. Die Heizung des Einfamiiienliauses und des Alietlauses. Umschau, 1926, 3D: 838 44.—Srhultze, P. Die Warmewirtschaft im Haiisc; der Kinzelofen und die Saminelheizung. Ibid, 844-7 — Seeger. R, Si Settele, E. Warnieteelnisohe Untersuchungen in der llolzsiedlung am Kochenliof Stuttgart, Gesundh. Ingenieur, 1938, 61: 693-9.—Yaglou, C. P. Heating and ventilation of homes. Commonhealth, Bost, 1938, 25: 139-43. ---- Economy. Breckenridoe, L. P., Sc Flagg, S. B. Saving fuel in heating a house. 35p. 8° Wash., 1917. Chowanecz, P. Betriebskostenvergleich der verschiedenen Wohnraumheizungen. Gesundh. Ingenieur, 1928, 51: 824- 6.—Degen, E. T. H. A. R.echnerische Ermittlung des Mess- fehleis bei den nach dem Verdunstungsprinzip arbeitenden Heizkostenverteilern. Ibid, 1939, 62: 593. -----■ Die Ermittlung der wirtschaftlichsten Grosse der Absperrorgane bei Pumpenheizungen. Ibid, 1941, 64: 217-9.—Eberle. Der Wirkungsgrad der Wohnungs-Sammelheizung. Ibid, 1928, 51: 644-7.—Eigenmann, A. Der Wiirmebezugspreis fur die Abnehmer bei Stadt lieizwerken. Ibid, 1926, 49: 242.—Griiss, H. Ein neuer Warmezahler als Grundlage der Heizkosten-Verrechnung. Ibid, 1938, 61: 725-8.—Hottinger, M. Der angemessene jiihrliche Koksverbrauch fiir Raum- heizung je m2 Kesselheizflache beziehungsweise je 1000 kcal Kesselleistung. Ibid, 1941, 64: 283-5.—Liniprecht, P. Warme- wirtschaft in industriellen Betrieben. Ibid, 1926, 49: 613- 22.—Lockwood, E. H. Some thoughts on the economics of domestic heating. J. Am. Soc. Heat. Ventil. Engin, 1927, 33: 299-308.—Meuerer, R. F. Betriebskostenvergleich der verschiedenen Wohnraumheizungen. Gesundh. Ingenieur, 1929, 52: 519.—Montgomery, G. L. Better heat use speeds process, aids quality, saves fuel. Food Indust, 1941, 13: No. 11, 43-5.—Rossier, J. Wirtschaftliche Fertigung fur Zentralheizungsanlagen. Gesundh. Ingenieur, 1926, 49: 454- 9.—Rybka, K. Beitrag zur Frage der Herabsetzung der Betriebs- und AnschafTungskosten der Zentralheizungen. Ibid, 1927, 50: 68-70.— Schulz. Betriebskostenvergleich der verschiedenen Wohnraumhtizinigen. Ibid, 1928, 51: 609; 628.—Walson, C. M. Cost reduction in steam and hot water heating systems. Army AI. Bull, 1936, 36: 58-62.—Weber, A. P. Vereinfachte Warmebedarfsberechnung fiir den Kosten voranschlag. Gesundh. Ingenieur, 1941, 64: 295-7. HEATING 427 HEATING ----electric. Balcke, H. Wirtschaftliche Verwertung elektrischer Ueber- schussenergie fiir Heizung und Warmwasserbereitung. Ge- sundh. Ingenieur, 1928, 51: 641-4.—Brockdorff, R. von. Die Elektrizitat als Warmequelle fiir Heizung und Warmwasser- bereitung. Ibid, 1927, 50: 141-3.—Hottinger, M. Elektrische Heizung. Ibid, 1930, 53: 193.—Jaspers. B. Elektrische Raumheizung durch milde Wiirmestrahlen. Ibid, 1938, 61: 73-8. ------ Ein neues elektrisches Raumheizverfahren. Ibid, 157-60.—Lode, A. Ueber elektrische Raumheizung. Wien. klin. Wschr, 1931, 44: 824-8.—Mathis, C, & Heymann, P. Dispositif permettant de transformer une 6tuve k tempera- ture constante chauftee au p6trole en 6tuve dlectrique. Bull Soc. med. chir. Indo-chine, 1913, 4: 282, pl—Mielentz, F. Kraftheizungsbetrieb in einer Fursorgeanstalt. Zschr. ges. Krankenhauswes, 1929, 25: 405-8.— Schulz, W. Heizung durch Elektrizitat. Umschau, 1926, 30: 850-2. ■------ Zwolf hundert Wohnungen mit Elektroheizung. Ibid, 1928, 32: 837-9.—Sporn, P„ & McLenegan. D. W. An all electric heating, cooling and air conditioning system; installation and performance of plant using the heat pump principle. Tr. Am. Soc. Heat. Ventil. Engin, 1935, 41: 307-26.— Thesio, H. Le chauffage dlectrique consid6te comme chauffage d'appoint. Techn. san. mun. Par, 1935, 30: 320-3. ---- Evaluation. Croft, H. O. What scale does to boiler heat transmission coefficients. J. Am. Soc. Heat. Ventil. Engin, 1927, 33: 435- 9.—Gunther, R. Die Kennziffer jeder Heizung, ein wirksames Mittel zur Erzielung von Brennstoffersparnissen nach ein- heitlichen Richtlinien. Gesundh. Ingenieur, 1927, 50: 193- 8.—Holbrook, F. M. How design and operation of heating plant compare in an insulated office building. J. Am. Soe. Heat, Ventil. Engin, 1927, 33: 365-71.—Levitsky [Radiating energy and convection in hygiene of heating] Sovet. vrach. gaz, 1933, 37: 1081-7.—Pumpen-Warmwasserheizung und Niederdruckdampf heizung mit tiefstehenden Heizkorpern. Gesundh. Ingenieur, 1926, 49: 662-6.—Stiegler, L. Ueber den Wirkungsgrad von Heizungsanlagen. Ibid, 1929, 52: 625-9.— Th using, H. Die Temperatur- und Leistungsverhaltnisse in Pumpenwarmwasser-und Heisswasserheizungen. Ibid, 1941, 64: 143-8.—Wagener, G. Das Messen der Heizleistung von Zentralheizungskesseln. Ibid, 1927, 50: 201. ---- Fuel. See also Fire; Fuel: Garbage, Disposal, &c. Balcke, H. Abhitzeverwertung zur Destillatbereitung und nachgeschalteter Fernheizung. Gesundh. Ingenieur, 1928, 51 : 73; 81. ------ Abwarmeverwertung zur Bereitung hoch- wertigen Speisewassers (gekuppelte Destinations und Heiz- anlagen zur Verwertung der Briidenwarme) Ibid, 209-16.— Dalzell, J. R, & Hubbard, C. L. Firing equipment. In their Air Condit, Chic, 1939, 273-308.— Duzan, J. Le chauffage rentral aux huiles lourdes. Nature, Par, 1928, 56: 262-7.— Eberle, C. Die Warmeausniitzung in koksgeheizten Sammel- heizungskesseln. Gesundh. Ingenieur, 1929, 52: 301-4.— Gini, A. Gli impianti di accumulazione di calore e la loro applicazione al riscaldamento. Riv. intrenaz. ingegn. san, 1933, 1: 197-204.—J, O. Ein Stiefkind der Statistik. Um- schau, 1927, 31: 957.—Korting, J. Oelfeuerung fur Zentral- heizungen in Deutschland. Gesundh. Ingenieur, 1926, 49: 348-50.—Koschmieder, H. Die warmetechnische Ausniitzung des stadtischen Mulls. Ibid, 1930, 53: 17-21.—Lang, A. Ueber Oelfeuerung und Beschreibung einiger Anlagen in Holland. Ibid, 1926, 49: 550-5.—Legendre, R. Des com- bustibles accessoires. Nature, Par, 1941, 54-7.—Lepoivre, A. Le charbon de bois; quelques types de fours. Ibid, 19; passim— Pieper, P. Die Verfeuerung gasreicher Steinkohlen in Zentral- heizungskesseln. Gesundh. Ingenieur, 1935, 58: 289; 441. ----- Feuerungstechnische Untersuchungen an Zimmerofen mit verschiedenen Brennstoffen. Ibid, 1938, 61: 605-10.— Ranzi, L. Die Brennstoffe fur Zentralheizungskes.se!. Ibid, 1941, 64: 297-300.— Redenbacher, W. Verschiedene Wirkungs- weise der Dampf- und Feuerkochung bei Fliissigkeitsbehaltern. Ibid, 1926, 49: 416.—Schilling, H. Ueber die Verfeuerung billiger Brennstoffe. Ibid, 1934, 57: 445-8.—Schubert, F. Verfeuerung von Braunkohle in Zentralheizkesseln; Beschrei- bung einer Anlage. Ibid, 1926, 49: 380.—Schultze. Der BrennstofTverbrauch zentral beheizter Berliner Miethauser. Ibid, 1929, 52: 641.—Setz, M. Oelfeuerung fur Gebaude- heizung. Ibid, 1938, 61: 281-8.—Summers, G. J. A simply improvised oil and water flash fire. J. R, Army M. Corps, 1941, 77: 149.— Tilzen, M, & Kauko, Y. Die wirtsehaft.lichen Mog- lichkeiten der Anwendung von Spiritus als Brennstoff. Acta Univ. Tartu, 1924, 6: A, No. 8, 1-35. ---- Heat conservation, and loss. Sigman, C. T., & Ward, W. J., jr. How to cut fuel bills by reducing heat losses, p. 156--61. 24cm. 1941. Clipping from Popular Science, November 1941, 5:139, No. 5 Balcke, H. Warmespeicher fiir Grossheizungs- und Heiss- wasser-Bereitungs-Anlagen. Gesundh. Ingenieur, 1927, 50: 550-6.—Bohm. J. Die Grosse des Warmeverlustes durch Strahlung, Konvektion, Leitung und Verdunstung bei offenen eisernen Heisswasserbehaltem. Ibid, 1937, 60: 113-7 " Der Dampfdurchschlagverlust beim unmittelbaren Anwarmen von Wasser mit Dampf. Ibid, 1938, 61: 141-7__ Cammerer, I. S. Ueber die nachtliche Auskuhlung von Wohn- raumen bei Stillsetzen der Heizung und die Frage der Mindest- speicherwarme von Wandungen. Ibid, 1933, 56: 73-5— Drexler, P. Berechnung der Warmeverluste von Gebauden auf graphischem Wege. Ibid, 1929, 52: 689-92.—Eberle Versuche iiber die Luftdurchlassigkeit und den Warmeverlust von Fenstern. Ibid, 1928, 51: 566-70.—Haase, E. Verein- fachung der Warmevcrlustberechnung. Ibid, 1930, 53: 177- 9.—Houghten, F. C, Blackshaw, J. L, & Gutberlet,' C. Wind velocities near a building and thoir effect on heat loss. Tr Am. Soc. Heat. Ventil Engin, 1934, 40: 387-400.—Keller, A. Verminderung der Warme- und Luftdurchlassigkeit der Baukon- struktionen, besonders der Fenster zur Herabsetzung der Betriebs- und Anschaffungskosten der Zentralheizungen. Gesundh. Ingenieur, 1927, 50: 600.—Legendre, R. Comment se chauffer; des pertes de chaleur des locaux. Nature, Par, 1941, 18; passim.—Marin, A. Influence of stack effect on the heat loss in tall buildings. Tr. Am. Soc. Heat. Ventil. Engin 1934, 40: 377-86.— Matschinsky, W. Wie kann man die nutzbare Warmekapazitat der umschliessenden Gebaudeteile berechnen? Gesundh. Ingenieur, 1930, 53: 49-52.—Rybka, K. Verminderung der Warme- und Luftdurchlassigkeit der Baukon- struktionen, besonders der Fenster zur Herabsetzung der Betriebs- und Anschaffungskosten der Zentralheizungen. Ibid, 1928, 51: 428.—Siebeneicher, A. Berechnung der Warmeverluste von sich selbst iiberlassenen Wasserbehaltern sowie von Rohrleitungen. Ibid, 1927, 50: 896.—Stender, W. Druckverlust in langen Rohrleitungen unter Beriicksichtigung der Warmeverluste. Ibid, 1926, 49: 73-6.—Vogeler, R. F. Die Bewertung von Warmesehutzmassen. Ibid, 1936, 59: 657-9.—Zobel, C. Report on heat flow through a roof by re- search laboratory. J. Am. Soc. Heat. Ventil. Engin, 1927, 33: 309-25. ---- Heat production, and transmission. Balcke, H. Vorschlage zur Nutzbarmachung heisser Ab- wasser fur Heizung und Warmwasserbereitung. Gesundh. Ingenieur, 1928, 51: 161-9.—De Micheli, G. II calore per radiazione e sue applicazioni nei campo ospitaliero e nelle moderne costruzioni ad uso civile. Atti Congr. internaz. teen. san, 1931, 2. Congr, 3: 535-43.—Gronningsaeter, J. Die Steigerung der Warmeabgabe von Radiatoren durch direkte Frischlufteinlasse. Gesundh. Ingenieur, 1928, 51: 685-91.— Hottinger, M. Der Einfluss der Heizkorperaufstellung auf die Warmeabgabe. Ibid, 1929, 52: 737—McElgin, J. The distri- bution of steam in heat transfer surface. Tr. Am. Soc. Heat. Ventil Engin, 1936, 42: 309-20.—Mossin, O. von. Verhalten eines Dampfstrahles in Wasser. Gesundh. Ingenieur, 1926, 49: 357-64.—Rybka, K. Einfluss der Bauhohe der Radiatoren auf deren Warmeabgabe. Ibid, 1927, 50: 91.—Smolinski, H. Wahl der Warmefortleitungsmittel bei Fernheizwerken. Ibid, 1928, 51: 593-601. ---- Heat requirement. Antonov, L. P, & Zatuchny, A. I. [Determination of radia- tion temperature in closed buildings] Gig. san, Moskva, 1939, 4: No. 6, 25-32.--Beck, P. Neue oder alte Regeln fiir die Berechnung von Heizungsanlagen? Gesundh. Ingenieur, 1928, 51: 661; 791.—Cammerer, L S. Auswahl, Bemessung und Berechnung des Warmeschutzes bei Heizungsanlagen nach neuzeitlichen Gesichtspunkten. Ibid, 1927, 50: 680; 715.— Drobny, A. Neue Rechenschieber fur Nieder- und Hoch- druckdampf-, Schwerkraft- und Pumpen-Warmwasserheizun- gen. Ibid, 24-30.—Faltin, H. Die Entwicklung der Warme- bedarfsrechnung von Kirchen und Gtossriiumen. Ibid, 1937, 60: 397-401.—Haase, E. Ermittlung des Warmebedarfs fiir Heizzwecke bei Kupplung der Heizung mit anderen Anlagen. Ibid, 1930, 53: 97-9.—Hager, G. Berechnung von Stock- werksheizungen. Ibid, 1926, 49: 426-9.—Hottinger, M. Das heiztechnische Klima der Schweiz in den Wintern 1933-34 und 1934-35. Ibid, 1935, 58: 649-53. ------ Die Belastungs- kurven der Raumheizungen. Ibid, 1938, 61: 759-66.------ Klima und Heizung. Ibid, 1937, 60: 241; 257.—Houghten, F. C, & Gutberlet, C. Heating requirements of an office building as affected bv weather conditions. Tr. Am. Soc. Heat. Ventil. Engin, 1936, 42: 391-410—HiiUig. Zur Ein- fiihrung der Neuen Regeln zur Berechnung des Warmebedarfes von Gebiiuden. Gesundh. Ingenieur, 1929, 52: 285.------ Die Abkiihlung und Wiedererwarmung geheizter Raume. Ibid, 1930, 53: 609-16.—Kalous, K. Praktische Berechnung der Strahlungsheizung. Ibid, 1939, 62: 553-8.—Korting, J. Warmebedarfsbestimmung von Kirchen. Ibid, 1938, 61: 521.—Linden, A. J. ter. Der Temperaturverlauf in Gebauden bei einem unterbrochenen Heizbetriob. Ibid, 17-22.— Loftier, W. Heizungsanlagen in Sud-Amerika. Ibid, 1935, 58: 653.—Lorenzen, F. Nomogramme zur Berechnung von Heizungsanlagen. Ibid, 1926, 49: 281.—Matschinsky, W. Einfachste Verfahren zur Berechnung des Abkiihhmgs- und Anheizvorganges. Ibid, 1927, 50: 453 5. Mejstfik, J. Ueber die Bedeutung der klimatischen Werte und deren Einfluss auf die Beheizung von Gebauden in der Tschecho- slowakischen Republik. Ibid, 1936, 59: 45; 60.—Metzkow, K. N. Wie sind Kirchenheizungen zu berechnen? Ibid, 1926, 49: 601-3.—Missenard, A. Ueber einfache Verfahren zur Bestimmung der resultierenden Temperatur. Ibid, 1938, 61: HEATING 428 HEATING 737-9.—Moser, P. Ueber Heizdauer und Aussentempera- turen. Ibid, 1939, 62: 109-15.—Raiss, W. Der Einfluss des Klimas auf den lleizwnrnieledarf in Deutschland. Ibid, 1933, 56: 397—103.—-Roose. H. Der Warmebedarf nicht taglich beheizter Riiume (Kirchen, Siile usw.) und die Mangel der bisherigen Berechnungsweisen. Ibid, 1928, 51: 287-90.— Schmidt, E. Die neuen Regeln fiir die Berechnung von Hei- zungsanlagenund ihre wissenschaftlichen Grundlagen. Ibid, 717-21. ------ Die Berechnung von Heizungsanlagen nach den neuen Regeln. Ibid, 1929, 52: 290-8— Stiegler, L. Zur Geschichte der neuen Regeln. Ibid, 286-90.—Wierz, M. Warmebedarf von Kirchen und anderen Grossriiumen mit langeren Betriebsunterbrechungen. Ibid, 1934, 57: 37-40. ------ Die Berechnung des Anheizbedarfes von Kirchen und anderen Grossraumen unter Beriicksichtigung beliebiger Innen- und Aussentcmperaturcn, Wandstiirken und Baustoffen. Ibid, 1935, 58: 761-L—Winslow, C. E. A. Heating and ventilating requirements for housing. Contr. Dep. Pub. Health Yale, 1937-39, 16: No. 10, 1-3. ---- History. Bachmann, W, & Fleischer, L. Heizung und Luftung auf der (iesolei. Gesundh. Ingenieur, 1926, 49: 549.—Garrison, F. H. The hiMorv of heating, ventilation and lighting. Bull. N. Voik Acad. M, 1927, 2. ser, 3: 57-67.—Hough, W. Collec- tion of heating and lighting utensils in the United States Na- tional Museum. Bull. U. S. Nat. Mus, 1928, 141: 1-110, 99 pl—Htt. Alte Heiz- und Kaminanlagen in baltischen Herrenhausern. Gesundh. Ingenieur, 1927, 50: 923-5.— Martell, P. Zur Geschichte der Heizung. Zschr. Gewerbehyg, I Hans u. Wohnung] 1920, 1: 33-5.—Rybka, K. Streifbilder aus der Entwickelung der amerikanischen Hochhausheizung. Gesundh. Ingenieur, 1929, 52: 721-5. hot water. Abom. Ein neues System fiir Warmwasserheizung. Ge- sundh. Ingenieur, 1929, 52: 803.—Behrens, H. Rohrbemessung von Warmwasserheizungen. Ibid, 1926, 49: 152. Betriebsversuche mit einer neuartigen, selbsttritigen Umge- hungssteuerung fiir Umwalzpumpen von Warmwasserheizun- gen. Ibid, 1939, 62: 373-5.—Berli, F. W. Die Berechnung der Einrolir-Warinwasserheizung. Ibid, 1929, 52: 493-6 — Burt. B. F, & Lewis, S. R. Heating buildings with hot water. Tr. Am. Soe. Heat. Ventil Engin, 1934, 40: 55-66.—Ginsberg, O. Warmwasserheizungen, wie sie ausgefiihrt werden diirfen und wie sie nicht ausgefuhrt werden durften. Gesundh. Ingenieur, 1934, 57: 358-62.—Hottinger, M. Schwerkraft- oder Pumpenheizung? Ibid, 1929, 52: 657-60. Die Vor- und Rueklauftemperaturen bei Warmwasserheizun- gen. Ibid, 1930, 53: 81.— Jetter. G. Windkessel in Warm- wasserversoiguiigsanlageii. Ibid, 1928, 51:763.—Meisterhans, R. Kombinieite Sch well raft- und Pumpen-Wasserheizungen. Ibid, 583-7.—Modrovich, K. Der Gegenstromapparat bei Warinwasserheizungeu. Ibid., 1939, 62: 197.—Moeller, E. Die, Bereclinung von Wanneaustauschern. Ibid, 1927, 50: 747-50.—Ritter, P. Unter Patentschutz gestellte Warm- wasserheizungsanlagen. Ibid, 1939, 62: 262-4.—Rublic, R. Welchen Einfluss haben die Warmeverluste der Verteilungs- Rohrleitung bei der Warmwasserheizung? Ibid, 1926, 49: 508.—Rybka, K. Zur generellen Regelung von Warmwasser- heizungen. Ibid, 761.—Schmidt, G. Betrieb eines tiefste- henden Heizkorpers durch Rucklaufwasser bei einer Warm- wasserheizanlage. Ibid, 1927, 50:. 750.-—Spillhagen, W. Die Warmwasserschwerkraftheizung. Ibid, 1933, 56: 325-9. ------ Heisswasser als Warmetrager von Heizungsanlagen. Ibid, 1939, 62: 403-10.—ThUsing, H. Die Temperatur- und Leistungsverhaltnisse in Schwerkraftwarmwasserheizungen. Ibid, 725-8.—Wolf, B. Beharrungszustand bei Warm- wasserheizungen mit unterer Verteilung. Ibid, 1936, 59: 687.—Ziiblin, C. Heisswasser-Heizungsanlagen mit elek- trischer Beheizung in England. Ibid, 1938, 61: 785-7. ---- Piping. Behrens, H. Rohrleitungs-Rechenschieber. Gesundh Ingenieur, 1927, 50: 645-53.—Berli, F. W. Berechnung der Rohrleitung von Etagenheizungen. Ibid, 889-92.—Constantin, R. E. Die neue Einrohr-Etagenheizung. Ibid, 124-6.— Giesecke, F. E., & Smith, E. G. Pipe sizes for hot water heating systems; the results of cooperative research between the American Society of Heating and Ventilating Engineers and the Texas Engineering Experiment Station. Tr. Am Soc Heat. Ventil. Engin, 1929, 35: 419-42.—Hottinger, m! Von den Rohrnetzen bei Warmwasser- und Dampfzentral- heizungen, Brauchdampfanlagen und Warmwasserversorgun- gen. Gesundh. Ingenieur, 1927, 50: 677; 713; 779.—Paul, W. Faltcnrohr-Kompensatoren in Fernheizanlagen. Ibid, 1928] 51: 732-4.—Ruetz, H. Rohrwirtschaft im Zcntralheizungsbau' Ibid, 1930. 53: 241-6—Schmidt, K. Die Festpunktbelastung ernes Axial-Metallschlauch-Kompensators. Ibid, 1927, 50: 729-31. ------ Koswa-Ventilabscheider. Ibid, 1929', 52: 660. ---- Radiant heating. Barker, A. H. Room warming by radiation. Tr. Am. Soc Heat. Ventil. Engin, 1932, 38: 331.—Beck, P. Decken- Strahtungsneizung; ein Beitrag zur Kliirung. Gesundh Ingenieur, 1938, 61: 437-42. ------ Der Brennstoffbedarf bei Decken-Strahlungsheizungen. Ibid, 1939, 62: 140-2. ------ Diinische Feststellungen Uber den Warmevorbrauch bei Strahlungsheizungen. Ibid, 177-81.—Brandt, M. Dor heutige Stand der Strahlungsheizung. Ibid, 1938, 61: 649- 54.—Dammer, F. Gesunderes Wohnen auf unterliiftetcn, warmen Fussboden. Umschau, 1911, 45: 285.—Gini, A. Die Strahlungsheizung in Italien. Gesundh. Ingenieur, 1938, 61: 735-8.—Grbber, H. Gesichtspunkte fiir die Bewertung der Deckenheizung. Ibid, 57-61.—Hottinger. M. Deckcn- und Fussbodenheizung. Ibid, 1934, 57: 293-7.----- Beitrag zur Bercchnung und Beurteilung der Strahlungs- heizung. Ibid, 1938, 61: 449; 465.—Kalous, K. Wesen und Ausfiihrung der Strahlungsheizung. Ibid, 769-71.—Marcard, W, & Huppcrt, H. Versuche iiber den Anheizvorgang bei einer Deckenheizung. Ibid, 199-207.—Pelda, A. Vorschliigc zur Herabsetzung der Tragheit bei Deckcnheizungcn. Ibid 564-6.—Ritter, P. Strahlungsheizung. Ibid, 1939, 62: 513.—Rybka, K. R. Die Strahlheizung. Ibid, 1934, 57: 305-9.—Schneckenberg, E. Die Deckenheizung in der Briti- schen Botschaft in Washington. Ibid, 1931, 54: 65-70. - Willner, M. Die wahren Eigenschaften der Strahlungsheizung Ibid, 1939, 62: 235. Radiator. Bernstein, H. Raum-Wirkungsgrade von Heizkorpern. Gesundh. Ingenieur, 1927, 50: 928-32.—Brabbee, K. Die Wirkung von Heizkorpern; ein praktlsches Verfahren fiir die Priifung von Heizkorpern durch Vergleich. Ibid, 1926, 49: 329 34.— Dalzell, J. R, & Hubbard, C. L. Radiators. In their Air Condit, Chic, 1939, 141-70.—Donnelly, J. A. Re- port of tests of radiator steam traps. Tr. Am. Soc. Heat. Ventil. Engin, 1913, 19: 197-201.—Ferdinand, A. Neue Verbindungen von Blechradiatoren. Gesundh. Ingenieur, 1923, 46: 197.—Griffiths, E. D. Test of radiator steam traps, Engineering Department, State of California. Tr. Am. Soc Heat. Ventil. Engin, 1913, 19: 194-6.—Hamaker, H. J. Warmeabgabe von Heizkorpern fiir Sammelheizungen. Ge- sundh. Ingenieur, 1941, 64: 4-9.—Kratz, A. P, & Fahncstock, M. K. Effect of enclosures on radiator performance. J. Am. Soc. Heat. Ventil Engin, 1927, 33: 353-64.—Meier, K. Warmeleistung, Wirkungsweise und Wirkungsgrad der Radia- toren. Gesundh. Ingenieur, 1927, 50: 89-91.—Meisterhans, R. Die praktische Bewertung der Warmeleistung von Heizkorpern. Ibid, 1930, 53: 161-4.—Meyer, K. Neuere Gesichtspunkte iiber Radiatoren. Ibid, 1927, 50: 198-201.—Pohl, M. von. Ein Heizkbrner russischer Bauweise und seine Berechnung. Ibid, 1938, 61: 314.—Rybka, K. Radiatoren kleinen Inhaltes und ihre Verwendung bei Warmwasserheizungen. Ibid, 1927, 50: 225r7— Willard, A. C, Krat7, A. P. (et al] Investigation of heating rooms with direct steam radiators equipped with enclosures and shields. Tr. Am. Soc. Heat. Ventil Engin, 1929, 35: 77-118. ---- Sanitation. See also Smoke. Pesch, H. U. *Studien uber den Kohlen- oxydgehalt der Zimmerluft bei Heizung mit Verschlusskachelofen. 29p. 8? Halle, 1930. Bauer, B, & Ruegg, F. Die messtechnische Erfassung und die Abscheidung der Flugstaubmengen im Rauchgasabzug dea Fernheizkraftswerks der Eidg. Technischen Hochschule in Ziinch. Gesundh. Ingenieur, 1936, 59: 729; 747.—Brunnings, W. Das Zimmerklima. Med. Klin, Berl, 1936, 32: 470 — Burgers. Hygienische Bedeutung der Luftung und Heizung (ein Ruck- und Ausblick) Gesundh. Ingenieur, 1927, 50: 661- 6.—Davydov, S. A. [Electrofilters for ridding central heating plants of smoke gases] Gig. & zdorov, 1941, 6: No. 5, 36-40.— Delbrassinne, F. Conditions d'installation des conduits d evacuation des chaudieres a gaz. Techn. san. mun. Par, 1933, 28: 337-9.—Hauptmann, W. Ueber die hygienischen Bedenken gegen die schornsteinlose Raumheizung mit Petro- leumofen. Wien. med. Wschr, 1932, 82: 49-52.—Houghten, F. C, & McDermott. P. Cold walls and their relation to the feeling of warmth. Tr. Am. Soc. Heat. Ventil. Engin, 1933, 39: 83-94.—Jusatz, H. J. Einige arztliche Gesichtspunkte zu Heizungs- und Luftungsfrage. Gesundh. Ingenieur, 1937, 60: a80-5.—Kemkes, B., & Bormann, F. von. Einiges uber die Hygiene der Zentralheizung. Med. Welt, 1939, 13: 62 — Liese. W. Temperaturbeobachtungen im beheizten Raum und l:crecooS1^msc Bedeutung. Arb. Reichsgesundhamt, 1933, 66: 633-7.------ Beleuchtung und Heizung. Deut. med. Wschr, 1933, 59: 1831-3.—Mayer, E. G. Neuere Unter- suchungen des Klimas beheizter Wohnraume. Med. Klin, Berl, 1938, 34: 678-80.—Missenard, A. Le chauffage des habitations du point de vue physiologique et hygienique. Presse med, 1938, 46: 1495-7.—Murakami, S. Hygienic in- vestigations on ventilation and heating in Manchuria; on natural ventilation. J. Orient. M, Dairen, 1940, 32: 80.— Osborne, H. Domestic heating and atmospheric pollution. Med Off Lond, 1931, 45: 121. ------ Smokeless fuel and sulphur elimination. Ibid, 1936, 55: 27.—Ra, K. Einwirkung der Zentralheizung auf die Volksgesundheit. Gesundh. Ingenieur 1928, 51: 369—Recknagel, H. Entstehen brenz- ilon F.Eodukte bei Temperaturen unter 80° C? Ibid, 1916, 39: 189.—Schereschewsky, M. Le chauffage urbain dans ses rapgorts avec l'hygiene et la salubrite urbaine. Ann. hvg. Par, 1933, n. ser, 11: 65-75.—Stegemann, R. Warmewirtschaft HEATING 429 HEATING und Wohnungshygiene. Gesundh. Ingenieur, 1927, 50: 408- 11.—Vernon, H. M. Methods of heating and vertilating schools and their influence on health. Med. Off, Lond, 1928 39: 247. --- solar. Sec also Sun. Abbot, C. G. Utilizing heat from the sun. lip. 8? Wash., 1939. Alt, H. L. Sun effect and the design of solar heaters. Tr. Am. Soc. Heat. Ventil. Engin, 1935, 41: 131-48. --- steam. Baldwin, W. J. Steam heating for buildings. 12. ed. 260p. 8? N. Y., 1891. Bohm, A. Die regelbare Niederdruckdampfheizung. Gesundh. Ingenieur, 1938, 61: 757.—Dalzell, J. R, & Hubbard, C. L. Direct steam heating. In their Air Condit, Chic, 1939, 175-98.—Dunham, C. A. Pressure differences in steam heating systems and their bearing on operation; a comparative test of 2 types of heating systems. J. Am. Soc. Heat. Ventil. Engin, 1927, 33: 225-32.—Fischer, B. Die Anwendung der Elektro- ivarme fur Heizzwecke unter Zwischenschaltung von Wasser- dampf als Warmetrager. Gesundh. Ingenieur. 1936, 59: 120- 2.—Houghten, F. C, & Gutberlet, C. Flow of condensate and air in steam-heating returns. Tr. Am. Soc. Heat. Ventil. Engin, 1933, 39: 179-98.— Hamper, H. Versuche zur Ver- besserung der Niederdruckdampfheizung. Gesundh. Ingenieur, 1938, 61: 566-74. ------• Unterdruckdampfheizungsanlage Klostermann. Ibid, 668.—Ranzi, L. Die neuzeitliche Ent- wicklung von Dampfheizungsanlagen. Ibid., 753-7.—Schirmer, H. Verfahren und Einrichtung zum Regeln von Niederdruck- dampfheizungen. Ibid, 1926, 49: 229-31.—Steam heating of buildings. Nature, Lond, 1941, 148: 376.—Thinn, C. A. Heating with steam below atmospheric pressure. Tr. Am. Soc. Heat. Ventil Engin, 1929, 35: 211-32.—Walger, O. Die Berechnung von Unterdruck-Dampfheizungen mit besonderer Rucksicht auf die generelle Regelung. Gesundh. Ingenieur, 1927, 50: 597-600.—Werneburg. Zur Genehmigung von Dampfkesselanlagen, insbesondere von Niederdruckdampf- kesseln fur Raumheizung (mit neuester Gesetzgebung) Zschr. Gesundhtechn, 1935. 27: 285-94.—Zimmermann, O. Nieder- druckdampfheizung. Gesundh. Ingenieur, 1941, 64: 36. --- Stove. See also Chimney. Bander. Wrasenbeseitigung in Kiichenraumen nach dem neuen Verfahren System Sokopf. Heilanstalt, Lpz, 1912, 7: 39-41.—Beck, P. Zur Hygiene der Raumheizung mit eisernen Oefen. Gesundh. Ingenieur, 1928, 51: 508.—Bliimlein, C. Backofen im Romerkastell Saalburg. Umschau, 1928, 32: 997.—Bourdeaux. De chauffage par les poSles k pdtrole. Arch. med. beiges, 1910, 4. ser, 35: 26-35.—French, S. W. A collapsible tent stove, a modification of the Sibley stove. J. Mil. Sen'. Inst. U. S, 1914, 54: 34-6.—Liebetanz, R. Neuere Untersuchungen an eisernen Zimmerofen. Gesundh. Ingenieur, 1935, 58: 721.—Liese, W. Zur Hygiene der Raumheizung mit eisernen Oefen. Ibid, 1928, 51: 425-8.—Lowenstein, R. G. Der Samogres-Kochapparat. Illust. Mschr. arztl Polytechn, 1913, 35: 67-75.—Sanita. N. Ueber die Schadlichkeit der schornsteinlosen Oefen. Fukuoka acta med, 1937, 30: 135; 1938, 31: 152.—Schwalbach, O. Der transportable flammen- lose Heizofen (eine rationelle Neuheit auf warmetechnischem Gebiete) Zbl. Gewerbehyg., 1926, n. F, 3: 312-4. --- Technology. American Society of Heating and Venti- lating Engineers. Guide 1931; an instrument of service prepared for the profession and con- taining reference data on the design and specifica- tion of heating and ventilating systems [&c] v.9. 923p. 8? N. Y. [1931] Bruckmayer, F. Die Verwendung von Festigkeitsformeln fur warmetechnische Rechnungen. Gesundh. Ingenieur, 1941, 64: 1^1.—Hottinger, M. Einfliisse der Hohenlage auf die Berechnung von heiz- und lufttechnischen Anlagen. Ibid, 29; 46.—Krasnitzky, W. Schaubilder fur die Berechnung von Hochdruck-Dampfleitungen und Liiftungskanalen. Ibid, 61, ch.—Marel, A. van der. Erwarmung des Riicklaufwassers bei Stockwerksheizungen mit hochliegendem Riicklauf? Ibid, 285-7.—Schuize, G. Gleich-, Gegen- und Kreuzstrom in einheitlicher Darstellung. Ibid, 1935, 58: 169-76.—Slawik, E. Altes und Neues aus der Installationstechnik. Ibid, 1927, 50: 64-8.—Smolinski, H. Ermittlung des giinstigsten Dampf - gegendruckes bei Warm- oder Heisswasser-Femheizwerken. Ibid, 1928, 51: 730-2.—Zimmermann, W. Berechnung von Drosselquerschnitten fiir Wasserheizungen und Liiftungsan- Iagen. Ibid, 817-24. ■--- warm air. Derigs, F. Heizung und Luftung kleinster Raume; die Dampfluftheizung im Miinchner Ledigenheim. Gesundh. Ingenieur 1935, 58: 333-42.-Kratz, A. P., & Quereau, J. F. Analysis of the over-all efficiency of a residence heated by warm ?£•♦ « V Soc. Heat. Ventil Engin, 1929, 35: 361-76 — upitz. H. Luftheizungsanlagen als wirtschaftliche Heizung von Grossraumen. Techn. Gemeindebl, 1941, 44- 29-31 — hinzig, J. Ergebnisse eines Leistungsversuches an einer Feuer- Uittheizungsanlage. Gesundh. Ingenieur, 1927, 50: 751. ---- Warm water supply. Eigenmann, A. Warmwasserversorgung vom Heizungs- kessel aus. Gesundh. Ingenieur, 1926, 49: 149-51.—Mattick F Ausfuhrung der Mantel und Boden dampfbeheizter Warm- wasserbereiter. Ibid, 1927, 50: 45-52.—Wallis, D. B. Con- ywt water in the field. J. R. Army M. Corps, 1941 77- 268-70— Weihe, F. Warmwasserbereitungsanlagen. Gesundh. Ingenieur, 1929, 52: 559-61—Wierz. Fortschritte an Warm- wasserbereitungs- und Warmespeicheranlagen. Ibid, 1931, HEATING industry. See also Heating. Brabbee, K. Brabbee-Laboratorium fiir Heizung und Luftung. Gesundh. Ingenieur, 1927, 50: 342.—Dieterich, G. lechnische, wirtschaftliche und soziale Fragen der Heizungs- uidiistrie. Ibid, 41-4.—Feier (Die) des 25jahrigen Bestehens des Vereines Deutscher Heizungs-Ingenieure, Bezirk Berlin. Ibid, 1926, 49: 565—GroLer, H. Stand und Entwicklungs- nchtung des Heiz- und Luftungswesens. Ibid, 1938, 61: 505.—Heilmann, A. Funfzehnter Kongress fiir Heizung und Luftung. Ibid.. 603-5.—Letmathe, G. Das Heizungsfach in Argentimen. Ibid, 1929. 52: 769.—Marx, A. Die Tagun* uber Stridteheizung in Berlin am 23. und 24. Oktober 1925 Ibid, 1926, 49: 181. ------ Wohin fiihrt der Weg? die weitere Entwicklung der Heizungstechnik. Ibid, 1927, 50: 666-8.— Schifman, G. M., & Kaplinsky, I. L. [Sanitation of working conditions in modern heating industries] Gig. & zdorov, 1941, 6: No. 5, 7-14.—Seegers, F. Zentralheizungsfach gegen Nahrungsmittelverderb; ein Mahnruf zur Mitarbeit. Gesundh. Ingenieur, 1938, 61: 33.—Spillhagen, W. Das Arbeitsgebiet des Heizungsingenieurs einst und .jetzt. Ibid, 1939, 62: 205- 8.—Wentscher, D. Aus dem Heizungswesen der Vereinigten Staaten wahrend des Jahres 1928. Ibid, 1929, 52: 436-8. HEATING, piping, and air conditioning. Chic, v.1-3, 1929-31. Formerly Journal of the American Society of heating and ventilating engineers. HEATLEY, N. G. See Manton, S. M, & Heatley, N. G. Studies on the Ony- chophora [&c] p.411-64. 29cm. Lond, 1937. HEATON, Claude Edwin, 1898- Modern motherhood; a book of information on complete maternity care: prenatal-, delivery-, aftercare. xiii, 271p. pl. 8? N. Y., Farrar & Rinehart [1935] ---- A historical sketch of New York uni- versity College of Medicine, 1841-1941. p. 1. 29p. illust. (incl. portr.) 23cm. N. Y., New York Univ., 1941. HEATON, Lois. See Pittsburgh. University. Mellon Institute of Industrial Research. A list of the books, bulletins, journal contributions [&c] 80p. 8? Pittsb, 1927. HEATON, Walter, 1871- Temperament and sex in life and art. 144p. 21cm. Bost.. R. G. Badger [1919] HEAT perception. See also Cold sense. Desvatjx, A. G. "Introduction a une elude du courant de chaleur (principalement dans ses causes exterieures) et de la sensation de tem- perature. 404p. 8? Par., 1914. Frohwein, G. [E. H.] *Beitrag zur Physi- ologie des Temperatursinnes. p.591-605. 8° Berl., 1930. Also Arch. ges. Physiol, 1930, 225: Schroer, H. *Ueber Somatisierung und Objektivierung von reinen Temperaturreizen; Untersuchungen zur Neurophysiologie und -pathologie. p. 162-75. 8? Wiirzb., 1930. Also in Deut. Zschr. Nervenh, 1932, 126: Bazett, H. C. Temperature sense in man. In Temperature (Am. Inst. Physics) N. Y, 1941, 489-501.—Bull, H. O. Studies on conditioned responses in fishes; temperature perception in teleosts. J. Marine Biol. Ass. U. K, 1936, 21: 1-27.—Burnett, HEAT PERCEPTION 430 HEAT PERCEPTION N. ('., & Dallenbach. K. M. The cxpeiii nei of heat. Am. J. Psychol, 1927. 38: 418-31 Carmichael. I,. & Lehner, G. F. J. The development of temperature sensitivin during the fetal period. J. Genet. Psychol, 1937, 50: 217 27. -Crudden, C. H. Reactions "t newborn infants to thermal stimuli under con- Mai.t tactual conditions. J. Exp. Psychol, 1937, 20: 350-70.— Kbbecke. 1 .miicratursinn. Deut. med. Wschr, 1918, 44: 925.—Frey. M. von. Mechanism of temperature sensations. | Am. J. Physiol, 1930, 94: 505. ------Ott, P, & Schriever. H. Wie kommen Temperaturempfindungen zustaml ■'.' Zschr. Biol, 1930, 90: 161-6.—Goldtcheider, A. Temperatursinn des Menschen. In Handb. norm. path. Physiol (A. Bethe & G. Bergmann) Berl, 1926, 11: 131-64.—Hahn, H. Neue Anschauungen vom Temperatursinn. Deut. med. Wschr, 1927. 53: 528-30. ------ Die unmittelbare Ursache der Icmperaturempfindung. Klin. Wschr, 1936, 15: 931-3.— Hall, G. S, & Browne, C. E. Children's ideas of fire, heat, frost and cold. Pedag. Semin, Worcester, 1903, 10: 27-85.— Herget, C. M, & Hardy. J. D. Temperature sensation; the spatial summation of heat. Am. J. Physiol, 1941-42, 135: 426-'.). —Herter. K. Lntersuchungen uber den Temperatursinn der Feuerwanze (Pyrrbocoris apterus L.) Biol. Zbl, 1923, 43: 27-30.------Das thermotaktische Optimum bei Nagetieren, ein mendclndes Art- und Rassenmerkmal Zschr. veryc-hol. (10371 193s, 11. Congr, 371.—Grigoriev, N. F, & Steinhaus, L. N. I Use of the electrothermometer for determin- ing temperature sensibility] Nevropat. psikhiat, 1940, 9: No. 5. 9L—Hahn, H. Neue Methoden zur Untersuchung des Teniperatursinnes. In Handb. biol. Arbeitsmeth. (Abder- halden. E.) Berl, 1937, Abt. 5, 7: 2. H, 919-94.—Hardy, J. D, & Oppel, T. W. Studies in temperature sensation; the stimulation of cold sensation bv radiation. J. Clin. Invest, 1938. 17: 771-8.—Jenkins, W. L. Studies in thermal sensi- tivity; adaptation with a series of small circular stimulators. J. Exp. Psychol, 1937. 21: 670-7. ------ Adaptation with a series of small annular stimulators. Ibid, 1938, 22: 164—77. ------The reactions of untrained subjects to simultaneous warm + cold stimulation. Ibid, 451-61.—Korbsch, H. Ein Temperatursintiprufer fur die neuroloerische Praxis. Psychiat. neur. Wschr.. 1027. 29: 302.—Ogata, K. Technological notes on thermoaesthesiomctrv. J. Orient. M, Dairen, 1936, 25: 70.—Porak, R. lest de la temperature en psychophysiologic humaine. Rev. g: 67- SI. -Stone, L. J, & Dallenbach, K. M. Adaptation to tie pain of radiant heat. Am. J. Psvchol , i 1934, 46: 229-42. Wilde, K. Zur I'lanoineiiologie des Warmeschmerzes. Psychol. Forsch, 1935, 20: 262-321. ---- Pathways, and end organs. Kaestner, E. [geb. Greber] *Methodische.s zur Bestimmung des Reizortes der Tempera- turnerven [Berlin] p.110-31. 8? Lpz., 1931. Also Zschr. Psychol Physiol Sinnesorg, 2. Abt, 1931, 62: Albertoni, P. Innervation thcrmi<|uc et innervation tro- phique. Arch, internal, phvsiol, Liege, 1921, 18: 35 11.— Bazett, H. C, & McGlone, B. Studies in sensation; chemical factor in the stimulation of end-organ giving temperature sensations. Arch. Neur. Psychiat, Chic, 1932, 28: 71 01. ------& Brocklehurst, R. J. The temperatures in the tissues which accompany temperature sensations. J. Physiol, lond, 1030, 69: 88-112.—Elo, J, & Nikula, A. Zur Topoi'raphie dea Warinesinnes. Skand. Arch. Physiol, Lpz., 1910, 24: 220 46.— Frohwein, G. Ueber den Reizort, die Empfindliclikeit und die Erregbarkeit der Temperaturnerveu. Aid. ires. Physiol, 1930, 225: 591-605. ------ & Hahn, H. Situs inversus von Temperaturnerven. Zschr. ges. phys. Ther, 1928, 35: 138- 48.—Hahn, H, & Lueg, W. Leber den Wirkungsbezirk von Temperaturreizen. Zschr. Psychol Phvsiol. Sinnesorg, 2. Abt, 1926-27, 58: 188-94.—Hardy, J. D, & Oppel, T. W. Studies in temperature sensation; the sensitivity of the body to heat and the spatial summation of the end organ responses. J. Clin. Invest, 1937. 16: 533-40.—Jenkins, W. I, Studies in thermal sensitivity: the reliability of seriatim cold-mapping with untrained subjects. J. Exp. Psvchol, 1939, 24: 278-93. ------ Part-whole relations in sei iatim cold-mapping. Ibid, 25: 373-88. ------ Part-whole relations in seriatim warm- mapping. Ibid, 1940, 27:76-80.—Jones, F.N. The chronaxy of cold and warmth. Am. J. Psychol, 1940, 53: 216-28.— Kiesow, F. Considerazioni sopra gli organi periferici dello sensazioni di temperatura. Arch. ital. psicol, 1933, II: 157-66. ------e collection in library. ---- & HEDON, L. Pancreas; secretion in- terne. p.19-96. 8? [Par., 1928] In Traite' phvsiol. norm. path. (Roger, G. H. & Binet, L.) Par, 1928, 4: 19-96. HEDONAL. See under Urethane. HEDOU, Henri. Recherches d'ordre chimique, bacteriologique et thdrapeutique sur les dents et les caries dentaires. 104p. 8? Nancy, Imp. Lorraine, 1919. HEDRICH, Carl, 1889- *Ueber das kongenitale maligne Neuroblastom der Neben- niere. 24p. 8? Frankf. a. M., F. Eichhorn, 1919. HEDRICH, Hans, 1903- "Ueber den wirtschaf tlichen Wert der Ovariotomie bei Stuten [Giessen] 31p. 22cm. Diisseld., G. H. Nolte, 1937. HEDRICK, Harold Bertram, 1890-1938. Obituary. Tr. Am. Acad. Ophth. Otolar, 1938, 425. HEDRICK, U[lysses] P[rentiss] 1870- lor portrait, photograph, see collection in library. HEDRIOCYSTIS. See Heliozoa. HEDVALL, Carl Erik Johan, 1896- *Ein Beitrag zur Frage des Mechanismus der Immu- nitat gegen Tuberkulose. 113p. 8? Stockh., I. Marcus, 1930. Also Sven. lak. sail, hand, 1930, 55: HEDYOTIS. See also Cholera, Treatment. Bhandarkar, P. R. Action of Hedyotis auricularia in cholera. J. Am. Ass. Med. Phys. Res, 1929-30. 8: 229-34. HEEBNER, Charles F. Manual of pharmacy and pharmaceutical chemistry, xi, 213p. 12? X. Y., 1887. HEEDER, Horst, 1909- *Beitrage zur Geschichte, Pathologie und Aetiologie der Myo- sitis ossificans progressiva (mit Bericht iiber einen neuen Krankheitsfall) 23p. 8? Berl., R. Pfau, 1936. HEEGE, Bernhard, 1913- *Ueber Haufig- keit und Art der echten Hirngeschwulste an Hand der Sektionen des Wurzburger Patho- logischen Institutes [Wurzburg] 27p. 8? Werne-Lippe, F. Grube, 1937. HEEGER, Horst, 1908- *Ueber Schadel- basisfrakturen und deren Ausfallserscheinungen im Sinne der Unfallbegutachtung [Rostock] 32p. 8? Zeulenroda, A. Oberreuter, 1933. HEEL. See also Gait; Shoe. For the anatomical heel of the body see Calcaneus. Lange, H. *Der Absatz am Schuh; seine Entwicklung, seine Beurteilung in der Literatur und seine mechanischen Wirkungen auf das Gehen und Stehen [Berlin] 38p. 8? Gutersloh, 1936. Piana, M. T. [n6e Facchinetti] *Etude et hygiene de la marche a talon haute chez la femme. 43p. 24cm. Par. [1940] Ashley, I). D. Criticism of the ordinary shoe: the heel seat. Med. Rec, X. Y, 1935, 142: 67; 569. ------ The relation of the heel-)iiece to the calcaneus. Ibid, 1936, 143: 421-4. ------ Types of heel -pieces. Ibid, 1937, 146: 490 3. ------ Typos of heel-pieces; the persistent higher lateral elevation of the heel-piece. Ibid, 1938, 147: 166-9.—Cook. A. G. The anterior heel: a further contribution to the Question of balance. HEEL 437 HEERFORDT'S Am. J. Orthop. Surg, 1911-12, 9: 37-59—Eggleston, A. A. Eliminating guesswork in heel correction; an accurate means of measuring shoe correction in treatment of short lower extremity. J. Osteopathy, 1939, 66: No. 9, 11.—F.verly, A. C. Heel elevation in relation to developmental growth; high heels and narrow toes in adolescence lay foundation for future troubles. Clin. J. Chiropody, 1934, 6: 226.—Fischer. K. W. Die naturliche Stulzung des Fusses durch den mittleren Seitenabsatz; ein Beitrag zur Schuhreform. Deut. med. Wschr, 1938, 64: 710-2.—Geissenhoner, G. Der Einfluss hoher Schuhabsatze auf die Sichc.rheit beim Gehen. Zbl. Gewerbehyg, 1939, n. F.. 16: 59.—Glasewald. Der Absatz; eine kulturhistorisch-medizinische Studie. Veroff. Volksge- sundhdienst, 1937, 49: 543-74.—Koppe. W. P. Why heels on shoes? answers questions: why heels on shoes? how much of this decadence (human foot growing less perfect) is due to the custom of wearing heeled shoes? Clin. J. Chiropody, 1936 8: 5-7.—Lake, N. C. Effect of high heels. Health Shoe Digest, 1936, 1: No. 9, 10-6.—Meice, H, & Huard, S. La cambrure du tendon d'Achille et le talon k double itage. Presse med, 1927, 35: 1531-4.—Meyer, H. Ueber die Lage des Absatzes beim normalen Schuh. Arch, orthop. UnfaUchir, 1926 24: 39-47.—New (A) heel for walking shoes. U. S. Nav. M. Bull, 1912, 6: pl—Penney, A. O. The high heel; a field for scientific research. J. Nat. Ass. Chiropod, 1939, 29: No. 7, 5.—Reed, E. N. Tilted heels or tilted shoes. J. Bone Surg, 1934, 16: 471.—Romich. S. Bestimmung der indi- viduellen Absatzhohe. Zschr. orthop. Chir, 1932, 57: 596-9. -----Richtige Absatzhohe. Zschr. Orthop, 1935-36, 64: 239-43.—Timmer. H. Statik und Mechanik des Fusses beim Stehen und Gehen in Schuhen ohne Absatze und mit Absiitzen (Vor- und Nachteile der Schuhe mit verschiedenen Absatzhohen und der Schuhe ohne Absatz) Zschr. orthop. Chir, 1935, 63: 227-62. ------ Apparat zur Demonstration der Muskel- und Bandspannung im Fuss beim Stehen in Schuhen ohne Absatze und in Schuhen mit Absritzen verschiedener Hohe. Verh. Deut. orthop. Ges. (1935) 1936, 30. Kongr. 134-8.— Why heels on shoes? Clin. J. Chiropody, 1937-38, 9: 20. HEELSBERGEN, Teunis van, 1862- Mens:h und Tier im Zyklus des Kontagiums; der Zusammenhang zwischen Krankheiten bei Mensch und Tier, xv, 167p. pl. 8? Stuttg., F. Enke, 1930. HEEM, Gustave Arthur Achille Cornil, 1909- *Le liquide cephalo-rachidien dans les traumatismes du crane. 95p. 24cm. Lille, G. Sautai, 1934. HEENK, J[acob] A[nne] L[eonard] *Verslag der verloskundige kliniek en polikliniek van het academisch Ziekenhuis te Leiden, cursus 1894-95. 235p. 23cm. Leiden, Gebr. van der Hoek, 1900. HEEP, Rudolf, 1904- *Ueber post- operative Lungenkomplikationen und ihre Pro- phylaxe [Freiburg] 14p. 8? Berl., H. Heene- mann, 1930. HEER, Carl, 1909- *Aortenruptur un- mittelbar post partum [Zurich] 16p. pl. 22}^cm. Aarau, H. R. Sauerlander & co., 1939. HEER, Fritz. *Zwei Falle von malignen kleinen Diinndarmcarcinomen. 15p. 8? Ziir., Gebr. Leemann & co., 1925. HEER, Jean, 1904- *Die Handwurzel- verletzungen im Suval-Material der Jahre 1924- 28. 34p. 8? Ziir., Gebr. Leemann & co., 1931. HEER, Walter, 1909- *Biegungsfestig- keit und Volumenverlust von selbstgebrannten Porzellankorpern nach wiederholtem Brennen [Munchen] 29p. 8? Augsb., H. Heber, 1935. HEER, Walther. *Ueber die Behandlung von Blutungen in der II. Halite der Schwangerschaft und in der Eroffnungsperiode; achtzig Falle von Sectio Caesarea bei Placenta praevia und bei vorzeitiger Ablosung der Placenta an der Geburtshilflich-Gynakologischen Abteilung der Kantonalen Krankenanstalt Aarau 1921-26 [Zurich] 18p. Reinach, E. Tenger, 1927. HEERDEGEN, Karl, 1900- *Submu- coses, gestieltes, verjauchtes Myom im Puer- perium. 26p. 8? Miinch. [R. Oldenbourg] 1929. HEERDEN, Anne Petronella van. *Die sogenaamde adenomiome van de ovarium, 96p. 8? Amst., H. J. Paris, 1923. HEERFORDT'S syndrome. See Granuloma benignum, Manifestation, ocular. HEERFURTH [Bruno] Armin, 1874- *Zur Kenntnis der Schwefel-Verbindungen im Leuchtgase. 52p. 8? Lpz., B. Georgi, 1906. HEERHARTZ, Werner, 1906- *Klinische Verwertbarkeit der1 Aschheim-Zondek'schen Re- aktion; Nachuntersuchungen an der Universi- tats-Frauenklinik Halle a. Saale [Halle] 16p 8? Bleicherode, C. Nieft, 1934. HEERING [Christoph] Helmut, 1908- *Ueber das Courvoisier'sche Gesetz. 26p. 8? Kiel, K. J. Rossier, 1934. HEERKLOTZ, Konrad, 1904- ♦Aktino- mykose der weiblichen Genitalien [Leipzig] 33p. 8? Dresd., M. Dittert & co., 1935. HEERWAGEN, Werner [Rudolf] 1898- *Die Trinkerfursorge in Tilsit Stadt und Land mit besonderer Beriicksichtigung der Jahre 1928- 29 Konigsberg i. Pr.] 26p. 8? Berl., W. de Gruyter & co., 1930 Also Allg. Zschr. Psychiat, 1930, 94: HEES, Corneille Adrien van, 1873- IFortieth anniversary of medical work] Ned. tschr. geneesk.. 1940, 84: 4002, portr. HEESE, Joachim, 1908- *Die Leistungen der hauslichen Geburtshilfe nach einer Statistik iiber 26,299 geburtshilfliche Falle in Mecklenburg. 24p. 21cm. Rostock, Adler, 1936. HEESE, Margarete, 1909- *Das Vor- kommen der Varietat des Streptococcus lacticus in der Mundhohle. 30p. 8? Lpz., A. Edelmann, 1932. HEESEN, Hertha te, 1912- *Formen und Behandlung der Mundschleimhauttuher- kulose unter Berucksichtigung der Differential- diagnose. 23p. 23cm. Greifsw., H. Adler, 1937. HEESEN, Josef, 1909- *Die klinische Behandlung von Zahn und Kieferkrankheiten unter besonderer Berucksichtigung der Tatigkeit der Westdeutschen Kieferklinik in Dusseldorf [Munster] 22p. 8? Krefeld, J. van Acken, 1933. HEESEN [Josef] Wilhelm, 1906- "Ueber das Ergebnis der Placenta-praevia-Falle nach Tamponade. 42p. 8? Bonn [n. pub.] 1932. HEESEN, Rudolf, 1902- *Ueber Menin- gitis und Meningismus. 40p. 8? Bonn, P. Kubens, 1930. HEFELE, Franz, 1899- *Statistische Uebersicht iiber Krebshaufigkeit, Krebssterblich- keit und Krebsaltersbild in den Jahren 1900-29 an Hand von Jahresberichten unter besonderer Berucksichtigung von Schwaben und Ober- bayern sowie der Jodgebiete T61&, Heilbrunn, Allgau und Reichenhall. 52p. 8? Munch., C. Wolf & Sohn, 1934. HEFELE, Max, 1908- *Systematische Studien iiber Schiesspulvernachweis fiir gericht- lich-medizinische Zwecke. 46p. pl. 8? Miinch. Gerber [1934] HEFER, Johannes Heinrich, 1908- *Er- fahrungen mit Rontgenbestrahlung bei Hirn- geschwiilsten [Munster] 34p. 21cm. Quaken- briick, R. Kleinert, 1936. HEFFE, Hans Rudolf, 1909- *Eugenische Sterilisierungen. 31p. 25cm. Greifsw., H. Adler, 1936. HEFFELS, Hans, 1912- *Ueber die Einwirkung der anatomischen Verhaltnisse auf die Entstehung und Heilung der Schenkelhals- frakturen. 32p, 21cm, Bonn, A. Brand, 1937. HEFFNER 438 HEGER HEFFNER, Eugen, 1913- *Klinische und histologische Untersuchungen einer neuen Wurzelbehandlungsmethode nach Salkover. 15p. pl. 22cm. Wiirzb., R. Mayr, 1936. HEFFRON, Roderick, 1901- Pneumonia; with special reference to pneumococcus lobar pneumonia. xvii, 1080p. incl. illust. tab. diagr. 24cm. X. Y., Commonwealth Fund, 1939. See also Lord, Frederick T, & Heffron, R. Lobar pneumonia and serum therapy. 91p. 8! N. Y, 1936. ------ Pneu- monia and scrum therapy. 148p. 8°. N. Y, 1938. Also Lord, I. T, Robinson, E. S. A, & Heffron, R. Chemotherapy and serum therapy of pneumonia. 174p. 21J.£cm. N. Y, 1940. ------ The same. 276p. 18^cm. Mex, 1941. ----& ROBINSON, E. S. Final report of the Massachusetts pneumonia study and service 1931-35. p. 1-72. 8? Bost., Mass., Common- health, 1937. Forms v. 21. Xo. 1, Commonhealth, Bost. HEFFTER, Arthur, 1860-1925. Kionka. H. Nekrolog. Fortsch. Ther, 1925, 1: 129. ---- HEUBNER, W. [et al.] Handbuch der experimentellen Pharmakologie; bearb. von J. Bock, R. Boehm [et al.] 8v. 8? Berl., J. Springer, 1923-35. ---- The same. Erganzungswerk; hrsg. von W. Heubner & J. Schiiller. 7v. illust. tab. 8? Berl., J. Springer, 1935-38. HEFLEBOWER, Roy Cleveland, 1884- The value of studies in health and sanitation in war planning. 291. roy. 8? [n. p., n. pub.] 1933. Typewritten. HEFTI, Fritz. *Ueber Missbildungen der weiblichen Genitalorgane bei Aplasie der einen und Dystopie der andern Niere [Zurich] 23p. 8? Brugg [n. pub.] 1925. HEGAR, Alfred, 1830-1914. For FestM'hrift >"e underBerlin, Gesellschaft fiir Geburts- hilfe und Gynakologie 58p. 8° Freib. I B, 1930. For hiomai'hy .-ce Mschr. Geburtsh. Gyn, 1930, 84: 3-S, portr. (II. Sellheim; See also Martin, A. Personliche Ennnerungen an Alfred Heirar. Mschr. Geburtsh. Gyn, 1030, 84: 22.—Tauffer, W. Hcnars Wirken im Geiste Semmelweis; ein Beitrag zur Zeit- gcschichte. Ibid.. 8-21. HEGAR'S sign. See under Pregnancy. HEGEDUES, Josef, 1904- *Beitrage zur Therapie der Lungentuberkulose mit Gold- praparaten. 22p. 8? Wiirzb., A. V. Schneider, 1934. HEGEDUES, Imre, 1910- *Les ondes hertziennes courtes et leurs applications en gynecologic 70p. 8? Par., Imp. Studio, 1935. HEGEMANN, Ferdinand, 1911- *Patho- logisch-anatomische Beobachtungen an einem Prozess von diffuser Gliose. 17p. 22>^cm. Miinst., H. Buschmann, 1936. HEGEMANN, Friedrich, 1907- *Aktino- mykose des Mittelohres [Erlangen] 24p. 8? Essen, J. Heinemann, 1933. HEGEMANN, Hans [Heinrich] 1905- *Untersuchungen iiber zwei neuere Desinfek- tionsmittel Ufinol und Pomastin. 35p. 8? Bonn, P. Kubens, 1930. HEGENDOERFER, Johann, 1907- *Ein Fall von primarem descendierendem Tuben- carzinom. 42p. 8? Munch., B. Wagner, 1932. HEGENDORF. Der Terragraph; ein Hilfs- mittel zur Beobachtung und Erforschung der intimen Lebensvorgange frei lebender Tiere. p. 1. 180p. 46 illust. 8? Lpz., T. Thomas [1913?] HEGENER, A. J. *Infectious mononucleosis [St Mary's Hosp.] 9 1. 28cm. Grand Rapids, 1941. Typewritten. HEGER, Hans, 1855-1940. [liioL'n.pl v| Iii Gallcrie hervorrag. Ther. I'h armakogn. Geuenwart, Genev.. 1S'I7, ■'!'.» I, portr.- lObituarv] J. Am. Pharm. Ass, Pract. Pharm. Ed, 1940, 1: 155. HEGER, Paul, 1846-1925. For biography see Arch, internat. phvsiol, LieV', 1925, 2.V 217-20, portr. (L. Fiedericq) \lso Arch. sc. biol. Nap, 1026, 8: 230 (G. Jappelli) Also Bruxelles mM., 1925-20, 0: 63-65 fL. Stienon,! Also Ibid, 96-103 (J. Demoor) Also Bull. Acad. mid. Belgique, 1927, 5. ser, 7: 791-806, portr. (Kinase) lor portrait, photograph see collection in library. HEGER-GILBERT, F. Deontologie medicale 325p. 22cm. Brux., F. Larcier, 1937. HEGGE, Thorleif G. Zur Analyse des Lernens mit sinnvoller Verkniipfung. 187p. 8? Lpz., J. A. Barth, 1927. Forms Erganzbd 13, Zschr. Psychol. Physiol. Sinnesorg. 1. Abt, HEGGEMANN, Rudolf, 1908- *Unter- suchungen iiber vertikale und sagittale Abwei- chungen in den Kiefer-Gesichtsbeziehungen beim Deckbiss des Menschen mit besonderer Aus- wertung von Fcrn-Profil-Rontgenaufnahmen. 31p. 8? Bonn, H. Trapp, 1933. HEGGENDORN, Hans, 1905- "Unter- suchungen an pulpaamputierten Zahnen [Basel] 43p. 8? Pratteln, K. Schahl, 1932. HEGGLIN, Otto. *Zur Verbreitung und klinischen Bedeutung der Ascaridenallergie [Zurich] 14p. 8? Basel, B. Schwabe & co., 1928. Also Schweiz. med. Wschr, 1929, 59: 11-4. HEGGLIN, Robert, 1907- *Ueber Or- ganvolumen und Organgewicht nebst Bemerkun- gen iiber die Grossenbestimmungsmethoden. 31p. 8? Ziir., Tschopp & cie, 1934. HEGGS, F. Mitchell. The M. B., B. S. finals; a collection of the papers set at the London M. B., B. S. examination for the years 1920-35, classified and arranged in suitable sub-divisions. xvi, 95p. 8? Lond., J. & A. Churchill, 1935. HEGGUM, Holger Oluf, 1877-1926. Johannsen, E. W. [Obituary] Milita>rlaegen, 1926, 32: 103. HEGI, Albert, 1871-1937. Wildbolz, H. Nekrolog. Schweiz. med. Wschr, 1937, 67: 721. HEGI, Rudolf. *Die Entwicklung der Was- serversorgung von Basel vom XIII. Jahrhundert bis zur Gegenwart. 57p. 8? Basel [n. pub]. 1928. HEGLER, C[arl] Theodor,1878- Praktikum der wichtigsten Infektionskrankheiten. 186p. 8? Lpz., G. Thieme, 1934. ----& NAUCK, E. G. Tropenkrankhcit, p.1098-1212. 8? Berl., 1934. In Handb. inn. Med. (Bergmann, G. et al.) Berl, 1934, 1: HEGNER, C[arl] A[ugust] 1880- Re- fraktion, Sehscharfe, Akkommodation und Re- fraktionsanomalien des Auges. p.463-580. 8? Berl., 1937. In Handb. biol. Arbeitsmeth. (Abderhalden, E.) Berl. 1937, Abt. 5, T. 6, 1. Hiilfte. HEGNER, George Thomas, 1887- Hiller G. I. Biography. Marquette M. Rev, 1937-38, 2: 156. HEGNER, Kurt [Remigius] 1911- ♦Un- tersuchungen iiber die Schluckstrasse. 15p. 8? Frankf. a. M., -Kern & Birner, 1935. HEGNER, Robert William, 1880- Host- parasite relations between man and his intestinal Protozoa, xiii, 2 1. 231p. 3 pl. 8? N. Y., Century co. [1927] —— College zoology. 4. ed. xvi, 742p. illust. diagrs. 8? X. Y., Macmillan, 1937. For portrait, photograph, see collection in library. HEGNER 439 HEIDE ----& ANDREWS, Justin. Problems and methods of research in protozoology, ix, 532p. 8? N. Y., Macmillan co., 1930. HEGNER, Robert William, ROOT, Francis M., & AUGUSTINE, Donald L. Animal para- sitology, with special reference to man and domesticated animals, xxi, 731p. 8? N. Y., Cen- tury co. [1929] ----The same. Parasitology, with special reference to man and domesticated animals. xxi, 812p. illust. diagr. 8? N. Y., D. Appleton- Century co. [1938] HEHIR, Sir Patrick, 1859-1937. The medical profession in India, v, 139p. 8? Lond., H. Frowde, Hodder & Stoughton [1923] For biography see Guy's Hosp. Gaz, Lond, 1937, 51: 237. Also Lancet, Lond, 1937, 1: 1139, portr. HEHLE, Albert, 1899- *Das Erythema exsudativum multiforme in der Mundhohle. 31p. 8? Miinch. [n. pub.] 1927. HEHN, Hermann, 1907- *Ueber fiinf Falle von Luxationsfrakturen des Unterkiefer- kopfchens [Wurzburg] 15p. 21cm. Lauda, Stieber-Dr., 1936. HEIBERG, B0rge. *On the classification of vibrio cholerae and the cholera-like vibrios. 181p. tab. 8? Kbh., A. Busck, 1935. HEIBERG, Johan Ludwig, 1854- Geistes- krankheiten im klassischen Altertum. p. 1. 40p. 8? Berl., W. de Gruyter & co., 1927. --- Naturwissenschaften, Mathematik und Medizin im klassischen Altertum. 2. Aufl. 104p. 12? Lpz., B. G. Teubner, 1920. Also editor of Paulus Aegineta [Works] 2v. 8? Lpz, 1921-24. HEIBERG, Kristian Axel, 1880- Die Grundlage der Geschwulstlehre. 2 p. 1. 75p. illust. 8? Lpz., C. Kabitzsch, 1933. ---- Die leukamischen und leukotischen Atypien und Geschwulste und das Wesen der Leukamie. 28p. 8? Kbh., Levin & Munks- gaard, 1933. ---- Einige Carcinome und Adenome beim Menschen; ferner vom Krebs bei Tieren und in vitro. 53p. 8? Kbh., Levin & Munksgaard, 1934. ---- Mass und Zahl im Zelleben. 32p. illust. 8? Kbh., Levin & Munksgaard, 1934. ---- Weiteres iiber Geschwulste. 56p. incl. illust. tab. 21cm. Kbh., Levin & Munksgaard, 1938. HEIBERG, Povl. See Bj0rum, Maria Valborg, & Heiberg, Povl. De vigtigste f0demidlers relative 0konomiske [&c] 7p. 8°. Kbh, 1917. HEID, Gustav, 1909- *Ueber Cystin- steinbildung. 35p. 8? Bonn, H. Trapp, 1937. HEID, Josef [Franz] 1902- *Ueber den Nabelschnurvorfall. 88p. 4 1. 8? Freib. i. B., A. Mehlhase, 1925. HEIDBREDER, Edna, 1890- *An experi- mental study of thinking [Columbia Univ.] 175p. 8? N. Y. [n. pub.] 1924. Also Arch. Psychol. (R. S. Woodworth) N. Y, No. 73. HEIDBREDER, Walter, 1902- *Klini- sche und histologische Untersuchungen zur Frage der peptischen Jejunalgeschwure ■ bei vorderer Gastroenterostomie und Braunscher Anastomose [Wurzburg] p.685-700. 8? Berl., J. Springer, 1927. Also Arch. klin. Chir, 1927, 146: HEIDBRINCK, Erich, 1896- *Ueber systematisierte Enchondromatose des Skeletts. 51p. 8? Kiel, Schmidt & Klaunig, 1932. HEIDE, Erich, 1898- *Ueber die Per- spiratio insensibilis bei schweissdriisenlosen Tie- ren (Kaninchen) nebst einigen Versuchen am Menschen. p.684-9. 8? Berl., J. Springer, \-u28. Also Arch. Derm. Syph, Berl, 1928, 156: HEIDE, Hans, 1912- *Anfall und Ver- wertung der Schweineborsten in Deutschland [Giessen] 58p. 22cm. Diisseld., G. H. Nolte, 1938. HEIDE, Oswald auf der, 1907- *Die Mitwirkung des Zahnarztes bei der Identifika- tionen von Leichen [Munster] 31p. 8? Werne- Lippe, F. Grube, 1933. HEIDE, Werner, 1903- *Ueber die Therapie von retinierten Zahnen. 27p. 4 pl. 8? Lpz., A. Edelmann, 1933. HEIDECKER, Hertha, 1907- *Die Blut- beschaffenheit bei Morbus Basedow [Rostock] 24p. 8? Jena, G. Neuenhahn, 1935. HEIDECKER, Johannes [Josef] 1899- *Klinische Beitrage zur Diagnose und Behand- lung der Eileiterschwangerschaft. 48p. 8? Bresl. [n. pub.] 1925. HEIDEGGER, Eduard. Wurmtafeln zum Bestimmen der wichtigsten Haustierparasiten. viii, 121p. illust. 8? Stuttg., F. Enke, 1937. HEIDEGGER, Else. *Ein Fall von ange- borener Zwerchfellhernie in der II. Universitats- klinik fiir Frauenkrankheiten und Geburtshilfe zu Miinchen [Munchen] 20p. 8? Dusseld., G. H. Nolte, 1932. HEIDEL, Horst, 1910- ^Beobachtungen iiber endokrin bedingte hamorrhagische Dia- thesen. 35p. incl. 7 tab. 23cm. Berl., R. Pfau, 1938. HEIDEL, William Arthur, 1868- The heroic age of science; the conception, ideals, and methods of science among the ancient Greeks. vii, 203p. 8? Bait., Carnegie Inst. Washing- ton, 1933. ---- Hippocratic medicine; its spirit and method, xv p.; 149p. 21cm. N. Y., Columbia Univ. Press, 1941. HEIDELBACH, Gottfried, 1898- *Zur Frage der teleangiektatischen Granulome der Mundhohle. 24p. 8? Gott., W. Fr. Kaestner, 1925. HEIDELBERG, Germ. Bass. Die Anfange der Heilkunde in Alt-Heidelberg. Berl klin. Wschr, 1914, 51: 377.—Heidelberg, Spinoza and academic freedom. Nature, Lond, 1936, 137: 303. HEIDELBERG, Germ. Ruprecht-Karls- Universitat (*1386) A. Fiinf hundert funfzig Jahre Ruperto-Carola. Zschr. iirztl Fortbild, 1936, 33: 333.—Brink, C. D. The Heidelberg centenarv. S. Afr. M. J, 1936, 10: 546.—Jubilee celebration at Heidelberg. J. Am. M. Ass, 1936, 107: 979.—Schmieder, L. Die neue medizinische Klinik der Universitat Heidelberg. Zschr. ges. Krankenhauswes, 1926, 22: 131-4.—Universitat (Die) Heidelberg zur Feier ihres 550jahrigen Bestehens am 27. Juni 1936. Sitzber. Preuss. Akad. Wiss, phys. math. Kl, 1936, 333.—University of Heidelberg and new conceptions of science (from a correspondent) Nature, Lond, 1937, 139: 98-100 —Velden, R. von den. Von deutschen hohen Schulen: Heidelberg. Deut. med. Wschr, 1936, 62: 1350-3. HEIDEMANN, Adolf, 1908- *Ueber das Verhalten allergischer Hautreaktionen in allergenfreiem Milieu. 24p. 8? Rostock, C. Hinstorff, 1935. HEIDEMANN, Eduard. *Das Schadelma- terial aus dem Merowingischen Skelettgraber- felde Anderten (Kr. Burgdorf, Hannover) vom kiefer- und zahnanatomischen Standpunkte aus [Gottingen] 24p. 5 pl. 8? Hannover, Gebr. Schmidt, 1926. HEIDEMANN 440 HEIDINGER HEIDEMANN, Waldemar, 1909- *Die histologischen Veranderungen an den Brust- driisen infantiler Mause mit positiver Schwanger- schaftsreaktion nach Aschheim-Zondek [Kiel] 27p. 8? Gutersloh, 1933. HEIDEN, Dora, 1910- *Katadynsilber in der serologischen Praxis. 18p. 8? Rostock, E. Vettcr, 1933. HEIDEN, Karl August [Christian Ernst] 1909- *Ueber die histologischen Aenderun- gen der Hypophyse nach Injektion von Adrena- lin und Cortidvn [Rostock] 14p. 8? Wismar, J. Riickerts, 1936. HEIDENHAIN, Adolf, 1893- Ueber den Menschenhass; eine pathographische Unter- suchung iiber Jonathan Swift. 118p. portr. 8? Stuttg., F. Enke, 1934. ----Die Psychiatrie im Dienste der Wehr- macht. 53p. 25cm. Lpz., G. Thieme, 1938. HEIDENHAIN, Lotlar, 1860- Ueber das Problem der bosartigen Geschwulste; eine experimentelle und theoretische Untersuchung. 2v. vi, 153p.; vi, 207p. fol. BerL, J. Springer, 1928-30. For Festschrift see Deut. Zschr. Chir, 1930, 227: For biography sec Zbl. Chir, 1930, 57: 2225 (Briiunig) HEIDENHAIN, Martin, 1864- Syn- thetische Morphologie der Niere des Menschen; Bau und Entwickelung dargestellt auf neuer Grundlage. xvi, 270p. illust. pl. roy. 8? Leiden, E. J. Brill, 1937. See also Volkmann, R. von. Martin Heidenhain und die mikroskopische Technik. Zschr. wiss. Mikr, 1934-35 51- 309-15. HEIDENREICH, Arturo J. Titulos, trabajos y labor docente. 37p. 23cm. B. Air., A. G. Buffarini, 1941. HEIDENREICH [Robert] Horst, 1908- *Ueber die Behandlung von Gaumendefekten unter besonderer Berucksichtigung des Palatum durum [Leipzig] 25p. 23cm. Zeulenroda, A. Oberreuter, 1936. HEIDENREICH. VON SIEBOLD, Charlotte, 1788- Kaschade, R. Charlotte Heidenreich- von Siebold, die erste Frauenarztin Deutschlands. Zbl. Gyn, 1939, 63: 171-3 HEIDEPRIEM, Curt, 1900- "Ueber die progressive Lipodystrophie. 23p. pl. 8° Berl., E. Ebering, 1927. HEIDER, Kurt, 1908- *Die Beteiligung des Knochensystems bei der Lymphogranulo- matose. 30p. 2 pl. 8? Bresl., W. G. Korn, 1938. HEIDER, Otto, 1908- *Beitrage zur Casuistik und Prognose intraokularer Tumoren (Sarcom und Gliom) 21p. 8? Erlangen, K Dores, 1934. HEIDER, Wilhelm, 1902- *Zur Diagnose der Hypophysentumoren [Frankfurt a. M 1 p.27-46. 8? Lpz., C. Kabitzsch, 1928. Also Zschr. Laryng, 1928, 17: HEIDERICH, Friedrich, 1878- Kopf, Hals, Bauch und Becken des Kindes. p 321- 415. roy. 8? Miinch., J. F. Bergmann, 1934. In Handb. Anat. Kindes (Peter, Wetzel, u. a.) Miii Also editor of Handbuch der Anatomie des Kindes 1-2, 1927-1938. 2v. 26cm. Munch, 1927-38 HEIDESTER, Rudolf, 1912- *Ueber Verfahren zur Verbesserung der Ergebnisse der intravenosen Urographie [Munchen] 41p. 2 tab 21cm. Kallmiinz, M. Lassleben, 1938 HEIDINGER, Hans, 1903- *Geburten mit und ohne Dammerschlaf. 30n 8° Freih i. B., H. M. Muth, 1928, ' • ) Miinch, Bd. HEIDINGER, Max, 1893- *Kindes(d- tung bei Zwillingen; Mitteilung eines Falles [Heidelberg] Op. 8? Bruchsal-Badcn, J. Kruse & Sohnc, 1936. HEIDINGSFIELD, Myron S. See American Statistical Association. Journal Iinlrv v.1-34, 1888-19391 102p. 23 Kern. Wash.. 1911. HEIDLOFF [Christian Wilhelm] Martin, 1900 *Ein Fall von abnormem Ursprung der Arteria coronaria cordis sinistra aus der Arteria pulmonalis communis. 27p. 8? Lpz., A. Edelmann, 1926. HEIDRICH, Herbert, 1909- *Der Ein- fluss der Vitamine A, B, C und D auf den Fett- stoffwechsel [Breslau] 29p. 21cm. Borna, R. Noske, 1937. HEIDRICH, Horst [Armin Max] 1909- *Ueber die Ursachen des unterschiedliehen Rontgenbefundes bei Zahnwurzelgranulomen einerseits und Zahnwurzelzysten andererseits [Leipzig] 28p. 4 pl. 8? Zeulenroda, A. Ober- reuter, 1933. HEIDTMANN, Arnold, 1912- *Todes- ursachen bei pernicioser Anamie. 15p. 22cm. Rostock, G. Neumann, 1937. HEIDUSCHKA, Walter, 1909- *Ueber die von Ebner'schen Fibrillen in der Grund- substanz des Zahnbeins. 12p. 2 1. pl. 8° Wiirzb., R. Mayr, 1935. HEIER, Hans, 1905- *Z\vei Falle von Thalliumvergiftung. 19p. 8? Bonn, P. Kubens, 1931. HEIGEL, Franz, 1905- *Ueber Tuben- tuberkulose. 40p. 8? Miinch. [n. pub.] 1931. HEIGEL, K. T. von. Benjamin Thompson, Graf von Rumford: Festrede. 30p. roy. 8? Munch., Bayer. Akad. Wiss., 1915. HEIGHT and weight [including width] See also Anthropometry; Body [human]; Body constitution; Child, Biometry; Efficiency, physi- cal: Measurement; Female, human: Biotype; Gen; Growth [human] and its subdivisions. Christie, W. F. Ideal weight; a practical handbook for patients, lllp. 8? Lond., 1938. Bean, R. B. Stature throughout the world. Science, 1928, 67: 1-5.—Calligaris, G. Le catene lineari del corpo. Riv. sper. freniat, 1928-29, 52: 575-631.—Dorst, S. Body weight. In Cyclop. Med. (Piersol-Bortz) Phila, 1939, 2: 848-75 — Geigel, R. Korperlange und Korpei gewicht. Munch, med. V\ schr, 1927, 74: 1178-80.—Gray, H, & Walker, A. M. Length and weight. Am. J. Phys. Anthrop, 1922, 5: 231-8.—Hetenyi, G. [Body weight and circulation] Orvoskepzes, 1935, 25: 499-508.— Ledent, R. Peut-on faire grandir? Ann. mid. phys, A nvers, 1927, 20: 56-64.—Nicolucci, G. La statu ra dell uomo. Anomalo, Nap, 1891, 3: 225-31.—Regnault, F. Les facteurs de la taille humaine. Rev. gin. sc. pur, 1912, 23: 900.—Secher, K. (Normal weight, over- and underweight] Ugeskr. lager, 1931, 93: 445.—Shuttleworth, F. K. Body weight. Monogr. Soc. Res. Child Develop, 1937, 2: No. 5. Jl°~34/ "----- The prediction of mature stature. Hid, 1939, 4: No. 3, 59; 65— Valdivia Ponce, J". E. Monografia de talla. Rev. mid. peru, 1937, 9: 625-44.—Wilder, R. M. ,„,„ reflation of the weight of the body. Internat. CUn., 1932, 42. ser, 1: 30-41. ---- Abnormity. See also Dwarfism; Emaciation; Gigantism; Malnutrition; Obesity, &c. Achard, H. J. Obesity and leanness. Med. Herald, 1932, 51: 15; 39.—Allen, R. L. Weight deviation and health in a college group. Res. Q. Am. Phys. Educ. Ass, 1936, 7: 89-98.- Berliner, M. Die therapeutische Beeinflussung konstitutio- n'dler Magerkeit und Fettsucht. Tier. Gegenwart, 1932,73: 4)-.,.,.—Roller, R. Fettsucht und Magcrsucht. Wien. klin. W schr.. 1910, 53: 130-2.—Britten, R. H. Physical impairment ana weiirlit; a study of medical examination records of 3,037 men markedly under or over weight for height and age. Pub. Health Rep, Wash, 1933, 48: 926-44—Crain, K. A. The tallest man. Philadelphia M. J, 1902, 9 463--Dorst. S. Underweight. In Cyclop. Med. (Piersol-Bortz) Phila, 1939, HEIGHT 441 HEIGHT 2: 852-63.—Knight, A. S. Tables of overweight and under- weight corresponding to various mortality ratios. Abstr. Proc. Ass. Life Insur. M. Dir. America, 1922-23, 9: 193-99 — Nissler, C. W, & Gordon, B. The use of dextrose in the regula- tion of the body weight; with special reference to the effects in disturbances of the circulation and digestion. Pennsylvania M. J, 1929-30, 33: 132-4—Richardson, A. M. The average weight is not ideal; a scientific basis for diagnosing overweight. Med. Times, N. Y, 1925, 53: 297; 317. Also repr.—Rony, H. R. Obesity and leanness. Illinois M. J, 1931, 59: 302-15 — Verrier, H. Maigreur et obdsite. J. med. Lvon, 1933, 14: 735-44.—Very tall men. Bull, san, Montreal, 1938, 38: 11.— Weisse, F. S, & Strong, W.M. Twenty years of overweights selection and statistics. Abstr. Proc. Ass. Life Insur. M. Dir. America, 1924-25, 12: [Discussion] 24-62. --- Age factor. See also Growth [human] Ognibene, S. *Contribuicao a detcrminacao da idade, no vivo, pela estatura e peso. 51 p. 8°. S. Paulo, 1928. Araya. Z. Changes of correlation coefficient between height and weight with age. Jap. J. M. Sc, 1941, 9: Anat. Abstr.. 118.—Gray, H. The relation of weight to stature, bi-cristal diameter and age. Biometrika, Cambr, 1928. 20: 299-309.— Hamburger, C. Das Verhaltnis zwischen Alter und Korperge- wicht bei weissen Mausen. Endokrinologie, 1935-36, 16: 423-5.—Shuttleworth F. K. Average weights and instan- taneous gains in weight of males from early fetal to adult life. Monogr. Soc. Res. Child Develop, 1938, 3: No. 3. fig. 14. ----- Bodv weight; growth trends in a vera no weight. Ibid , 1939, 4: No. 3, 148-65.—Weissenberg, S. Das Korpergewicht nach Alter und Geschlecht. Zschr. ges. Anat, 2. Abt, 1924-25 10: 738-41. --- Determination. See also Anthropometry; Biometry. Breitmann, M. Zur Frage der Bestimmung des Standard- gewichts. Zschr. ges. Anat, 2. Abt, 1932, 17: 203-6.—Ciocco, A. Height of body in adults; survey of differences in methods of measuring, instruments and classifications. Am. J. Phys. Anthrop, 1936, 22: 141-51. ------ Sitting height and sitting- height/*' at.ure index in adults; survey of differences in methods of measuring, instruments and classifications. Ibid, 467-75.— Edwards, T. I. Computing scales for calculating percentage deviation from average weight. Science, 1942, 95: 50.— Gohar, H. A. F. Weighing living marine animals. Nature, Lond, 1941, 147: 177.—Goldstein, M. S. Weight, a survey of differences of method, instruments. Am. J. Phys. Anthrop, 1936, 22: 437-65.—Lowndes, A. G. Weighing living marine animals. Nature, Lond, 1941, 147: 298.—Metheny, E. The variability of the percentage index of build as applied to the prediction of normal weight. Human Biol, 1939, 11: 473-84.— Nat, B. S. Estimation of stature from long bones in Indians of the United Provinces: a medico-legal inquiry in anthropo- metry. Tnd. J. M. Res, 1931, 18: 1245-53.—Pryor, H. B, Shepard. C. E, & Moody, R. O. Determining appropriate body weight in relation to body build. J. Lancet, 1936, 56: 613-7.—Pryor, H. B, & Stolz, H. R. Determining appropriate weight for body build. J. Pediat, S. Louis, 1933, 3: 608-22 — Reichi'l IL Zur Frage der Korpergewichtsbeurteilung. Wien. med. Wschr, 1925, 75: 1833-9— Shelton, E. K. Optimal weight estimation, the method of Willoughbv. Endocrinology, 1932, 16: 492.—Soukup. F. K. Graph for determining weight variation. U. S. Nav. M. Bull, 1929, 27: 140-2.—Templeton. R. D.. & Patras, M. C. The weight curve complicated by deaths. J. Lab. Clin. M, 1937-38, 23: 874-9.—Turner, C. E. Precision and reliability of underweight measurement. Am. J. Pub. Health, 1929, 19: 969-79. --- Health aspect. Hauck, H. M. How to control your weight. 18p. 8? Ithaca, N. Y., 1935. Hay, W. H. Weight control. 85p. 16? N. Y. [1935] Body weight and longevitv. Pub. Health Rep, Wash, 1923. 38: 1271.—Dear, W. R. Body weight as an index of physical condition. Mil Surgeon, 1926, 59: 393-410.—Du Bray, E. S. Comments on body weight in relation to health and disasc. Am. J. M. Sc, 1925, 170: 564-75.—Emerson, W. R. J\, & Manny, F. A. Underweight and overweight in relation to vitality. J. Am. M. Ass, 1929, 93: 457.—Feltkamp T. E. W. [View-points and experiences in regard to the opti- mum weight of the human body] Ned. tschr. geneesk, 1935, 79: 1908-12.—Hutchison, R. Body-weisrht in relation to disease. Lancet, Lond, 1935, 1: 378. Also Tr. M. Soc. London, 1935, 58: 112-23.—Kildufle, R. A. The weight of the trans- gressor. Hygeia, Chic, 1938, 16: 896-8.—Leinbach, H, & Kinney, A. C. Weight control College J, Kansas City, 1940, 24: 82-90. —Litchfield, L. The importance of weight control in the maintenance of health and in the management of disease. Pennsylvania M. J, 1921-22, 25: 675-80.—Little, R. Diet for losing or gaining. Health, Mount. View, 1942, 9: No. 2, 12.— Miller, S. R. The problem and importance of weight, in rela- tion to general health J. M. Soc. N. Jersey, 1929, 26: 808- ITlT 3'i iai^S4°7nn °i Mr' Scientific weight control. J. Ayurveda, l.i.vt-3o 11: 470-4.—[Weight and duration of life] Geneesk tschr. Ned. Indie, 1938, 78: 884-8.-WetzeI, N. C. New New^Lett."!^!,M?218nd "'^ appraises heaIth" Scien<* ---- Heredity. See also Body constitution. ,n^en^t.yp!c;«s,elec>ion for wei^ht in mice- Nature, Lond, 1938, 141: 1104—Goodale, H. D. A study of the inheritance ?Lo y wclKht ln the albino mouse by selection. J. Hered 1938 29: 101-12.—Goto, K. On the influence of the father's height upon the growth of the children's height. Jap J M ' u941'j9: Anat> Abstr- 119.—Halban, J. Die Grossen- zunahme der Eier und Neugeborenen mit dem zunehmenden Alter der Mutter. Verh. Ges. deut. Naturforsch. (1909) 1910 V,l 2' Teil,*5- Halfte' 176.-Revesz. B. Der Einfluss des Alters der Mutter auf die Korperhohe. Arch. Anthrop Brnschw, 1906, n. F, 4: 160-7.—Shuttleworth, F. K. Stature! sternal height, and height of symphysis of 3 pairs of identical twin sisters at each age from 10 to 15. Monogr Soc Res Child Develop, 1938, 3: No. 3, fig. 42. ---- Normal averages, and tables. [America] Prudential Insurance Co. of America. Tables of height and weight at vary- ing ages; based upon an analysis of approved applications for life insurance on male lives [and] on female lives; medico-actuarial mortality in- vestigation, year 1912. 2 ch. 28V2 x 21cm. [Newark, 1913?] Godlewski, G. C. *Le poids normal; sa fixation en fonction de l'age, de la taille et du sexe; son maintien au cours de la vie. 24p. 25cm. Par., 1939. Pryor, H. B. Width-weight tables. 15p. 21 y2cm. Stanford Univ. [1936] Also 2. rev. ed. 15p. 28 x 21^cm. 1940. Basler, A. Die physiologische Korpergrosse; nach ge- meinsam mit Dr Schroller vorgenommenen Untersuchungen. Zschr. ges. Anat, 2. Abt, 1927, 13: 265-71.—Bazan, F., & Bayley Bustamante, G. Consideraciones sobre la tabla pondo- estatural y otros indices somatom6tricos. Bol. san, B. Air, 1938, 2: 575-81.— Behneman, H. M. Body weight in Naval and Marine corps applicants. Mil. Surgeon, 1927, 60: 701- 11.—Bell, G. H, & Knox, J. A. C. Nomogram of standard body weight in men; a note on McKinlay's formula. Glasgow M. J, 1938, 130: 294.—Clark, C. P. A study of tables of average weights for heights; using the Davenport index of build as a guide. Abstr. Proc. Ass. Life Insur. M. Dir. America, 1936, 22: 266-87.—Davenport, C. B. Height-weight index of build. Am. J. Phys. Anthrop, 1920, 3: 467-75.—Dunstan W. R. Frequency curves of heights and weights. Med. Off. Lond, 1930, 43: 15.—Emerson, W. R. P, & Manny, F. A Tables of average and optimum weight for height. Arch Pediat, N. Y, 1929, 46: 382-90.—Frassetto, F. Delle relazioni fra il peso e la statura nelluomo adulto. Med. ital, 1922, 3: 16-20.—Gray, H, & Allen, F. B. Bornhardt's formula. Boston M. & S. J, 1921, 184: 334-8.—Gray, H, & Root. H. F. Weight prediction by the formulae of Bornhardt, of von Pirquet, and of Dreyer. Ibid, 185: 28-32.—L, R. Le poids normal de I'individu. Mouvement hyg, Brux, 1913, 29: 133-7 — McKinlay, P. L. The basis of standard tables of body weight. Glasgow M. J, 1935, 123: 71-85.—Pillar, D. Formuldrio pedultrico e posologia por pfiso funcional. Rev. mid. mun, Rio, 1941, 1: 524-41.—Plattner, W. Ueber die Abhangigkeit der relativen Korpermasse von der Korpergrosse (Korrektur der Indices nach der Korperlange) Zschr. ges. Neur. Psychiat, 1931,132: 591-612.— Quimby, R. C. What a man should weigh. Res. Q. Am. Phys. Educ. Ass, 1934, 5: 91-109.—Richey, H. G. The weight and height of laboratory school children. Monogr. Soc. Res. Child Develop, 1937, 2: 9-17.—Schleissner, F. Tabellen zur graphischen Darstellung von Korperlange und Gewicht. Med. Klin, Berl, 1926, 22: 1798.—Shuttleworth, F. K. Smoothed average statures for Hawaiian, Chinese, Japanese, North European, and South European boys, age 6.5 to 18.5 years, in Hawaii. Monogr. Soc. Res. Child Develop, 1938, 3: No. 3, fig. 49, 50.—Sperk, B. Ueber das Normalge- wicht. Wien. klin. Wschr, 1921, 34: 210-2.—Troima, F. La formula di von Noorden e il peso normale dell'uomo all'et& di 20-25 anni. Gior. med. mil, 1931, 79: 249-54.—Viola, D. Sul peso corporeo medio in rapporto alia statura. Ibid, 1934, 82: 998-1003.—Wellisch, S. Ueber die Bedeutung des Ge- wichtslangenindex. Munch, med. Wschr, 1928, 75: 993. ---- Psychological aspect. See also Constitution; Mind and body. Scheuber, F. *Gewichtsunterscheidung und gcistige Entwicklung [Jena] 39p. 8? Stadt- roda, 1934. HEIGHT 442 HEIGHT Hillingslea, F. The relationship between emotionality, activitv, curiosity, persistence and weight in the male rat. J. Comp. Psychol, 1940, 29: 315-25.—Middleton, W. C. The relation of height and weight measurements to certain per- sonality qualities as measured bv the Bernrcuter inventory; some errata. J. I'syehol, 1941, 11: 421. ---- Sitting height, and trunk length. Bardeen. C. R. General relations of sitting height to stature and of sitting height and stature to weight. Am. J. Phvs. Anthrop, 1923, 6: 355-88.—Bean, R. B. 'the sitting height. Ibid, 1922, 5: 349-90. ------ The adult sitting height. Anat. Rec, 1920-21, 18: 222—Gray, H, & Root, H. F. Stem- length and trunk-length. Boston M. & S. .1, 1921. 184: 439- 43.—Shuttleworth, F. K. Sitting height and leg length. Monogr. Soc. lies. Child Develop, 1937, 2: No. 5, 78; 1939, 4: No. 3, 69.- Stuart. II. C, llardwick. R. L. [et al] Curves of growth in >it t ing leiigi I and trunk length; boys. Ibid, 1939, 4: No. 1, 228.-----('ui v.-- of growth in sitting length and trunk length; girls. Hud, 229. ---- Social factors. Boas, F. The relation between civilization and stature. J. Sociol. M, 1917, 18: 397-401 [Discussion] 417-21.— Jenss, R. M. Gain in weight and its association with ancestry and economic status. Human Biol, 1940, 12: 532-44.—Karlan, S. C. Increase in height and weight among the underprivileged. .1. School Health, 1942, 12: 58-61. Also N. York Slate J. M, 1941, 41: 2425. ---- Standing height. Shuttleworth, F. K. Individual patterns of growth in standing height. Monogr. Soc. Res. Child Develop, 1937, 2: No. 5. 51 77 ------ Distribution of ages of maximum growth in standing height by sex. Ibid, 1939, 4: No. 3, 9. ------Changing variabilities in the standing height of boys. Ibid, 9-68. ---- Variation. Backman, G. Longueur du corps au cours de la journde. C. rend. Soc. biol, 1924, 90: 1118-20. ------ Korperlange und Tageszcit. Uppsala lak. foren. forh., 1924, 29: 255-82 — Blitz. B. Osservazioni sul l'accrescimento ponderale in mal.-iti soggetti a cure sanatoriall Chir. org. movim, 1929, 14: 212-5.—Burwell, C. S. The interpretation of changes- in I .och weight. Med. Clin. N. America, 1928-29, 12: 1205-13.— Hovland, C. I. Hourly variations in weight loss following ingestion of food. Am. .1. Physiol, 1935, 111: 448-51.------ Weight loss changes during muscular work following food ingestion. Ibid, 112: 307-9. ------ Effects of ingestion of nutritive and non-nutritive liquids upon diurnal variations in weight loss. Ibid, 1935-36, 114: 235-9.—Kassowitz, K. Zur Frage der Beeinflussung der Korperlange und Korperfulle durch die Erniihrung. Wien. med. Wschr, 1921, 81: 1389.— Males, B, o\'s; plotted against the 10 to 90 percentile range for the boys of l le- normal series. Ibid, No. 1, 224.----- Curves of growth m weight, giils; plotted against the 10 to 90 percentile range for the girls of normal series. Ibid, 225. -----Curves of growth in length; boys. Ibid, 226.----- Curves of growth in length; girls. Ibid. 227. ---- in animals. Gunther [F. O.] H. *Das Gowichtsverhaltcn neugeborener Kalber beim schwarzbunten Tief- landrind. 47p. 21cm. Lpz., 1936. (-rile, G, & Quiring, D. P. A record of the body weight and certain organ and gland weights of 3,690 animals. Ohio .1. Sc, 1940, 40: 219-59.—Mazzocco, P. Variaciones csta- cional-s del peso y composici6n de los cuerpos adiposos del sapo Bufo arenarum Hensel Rev. Soc. argent, biol, 1940, 16: 129-38.—Varennes. Etude sur les variations de poids chez les animaux. Arch. mid. Angers, 1937, 41: 108.—Zucker, I,, ,4 Zucker, T. F. A simple time weight relit ion observed in well nourished rats. J. Gen. Physiol, 1941-12, 25: 4-15-63. HEIGL, Walter, 1912- *Schneidezahn- form, Grosse und Farbe der Zahne bei den Rassen des deutschen Volkes [Munchen] 24p 21cm. Wurzb., K. Triltsch, 1937. HEIJERMANS, Louis, 1873-1938. Hand- leiding tot de kennis der beroepsziekten. 2v. xv, 345p.; 420p. illust. tab. 25}£cm. Rotter- dam, W. L. & J. Brusse, 1926. ----Gemeentelij ke gesondheidszorg in Neder- land. 496p. roy. 8? Amst. [n. pub.] 1929. For biography see Arch. m6d. sociale, lirux, 1939, 2: 87 CL Beijerman) Also Tegen de tuberculose, 1938, 34: 118-20, portr. (J. A. Putto) HEIJL, Carl. Ueber Retiniten unbekannten Ursprungs nebst einer histopathologischen Studie uber Missbildungen des Sehorgans. 48p. 50 pl. roy. 8? Jena, G. Fischer, 1937. HEIJMANS, B. De renaissance in Italie gedurende de 15e eeuw benevens Levensschets van Da Vinci, xv, 184p. 8? Zutphen, W. J. Thieme & cie, 1919. HEIKEL, Rosina, 1842-1929. Eskelin, K. [Obituary] Fin. lak. sail hand, 1930, 72: 415-21. HEIL, Bruno, 1908- *Zur Kenntnis des lymphaemoiden Driisenfiebers (Marburg] 16p. 8? Gutersloh, Thiele, 1932. HEIL [Friedrich] Richard, 1905- *Papil- lome des Nierenbeckens [Halle] 23p. 21cm. Eislfiben, E. Schneider, 1937. HEIL, Julius Valentine, 1904- *Spinal anesthesia [Marquette Univ.] 15p. 4? Mil- waukee, 1930. Typewritten. HEILAND, Joseph, 1911- *Ovarigene Blutungen und haemorrhagische Diathese [Miin- chen] 34p. 22cm. Bonn, Kubens, 1937. HEILBERG, J. L. Naturwissenschaften, Mathematik und Medizin im klassischen Alter- tum. 2. Aufl. 104p. 12? Lpz., B. G. Teubner, 1920. HEILBORN, Adolf, 1873- Allgemeine Volkerkunde. 2v. viii, 136p.; viii, 116p. illust. 18^cm. Berl., B. G. Teubner, 1915. Forms Bd 487-8, Aus Natur nnd Geisteswelt. HEILBORN, Herta, 1903- *Zusammen- stellung der Missbildungen der Zunge und dea Zapfchens. 37p. 8? Bonn [n. pub.] 1934. ----*Wann ist der praktische Arzt verpflich- tet, bei Verletzungen eine prophylaktische Te- tanusantitoxin-Einspritzung zu machen? 32p. 8? Bonn [Breuer] 1937. HEILBORN, Rudolf, 1907- ♦Untersu- chungen zur Toxikologie des Natriumrhodanids [Breslau] 8p. 8? Lpz., F. C. W. Vogel, 1930. Also Arch. exp. Path, Lpz, 1930, 152: 250-6, HEILBORN 443 HEILMEYER HEILBORN, Werner, 1898- *Gangran des linken Fusses infolge supramalleolar Tibia- fraktur. 16p. 8? BerL, E. Ebering, 1927. HEILBRUN, Werner, 1902- *Ueber Versuche zum Nachweis der von den Oxyda- tionen abhangigen Warmebildung im Frosch- herzen. 20p. 3 ch. 8? Heidelb., H. Dorr, 1927. HEILBRUNN, Alfred, 1908- *Infek- tionsversuche an Menschen [Berlin] 104p. 21cm. Hildburghausen, F. W. Gadow & Sohn, 1937. HEILBRUNN, Julius, 1902- *Bakterio- logische Untersuchungen des Zahnfleischtaschen- inhaltes bei Paradentosen. 17p. 8? Wiirzb., C. J. Becker, 1928. HEILBRUNN, Lewis Victor, 1892- The colloid chemistry of protoplasm. vii, 356p. 8? Berl., Gebr. Borntraeger, 1928. --- An outline -of general physiology. 603p. illust. 8? Phila., W. B. Saunders co., 1937. HEILEMANN, Harri, 1908- *Zur Be- handlung der Arhythmia absoluta. 18p. 8°. Lpz., A. Edelmann, 1937. HEILHECKER, Adolf, 1909- *Garungs- hemmende Stoffe im Blute bei akuten Infek- tionskrankheiten im Kindesalter. 22p. 8? Frankf. a. M., R. Fiedler, 1935. HEILIG, Erwin, 1899- *Ueber die Aetiologie des Schwangerenodems. 30p. 8°. Frankf. a. M., Miinch, 1927. HEILING, Hans, 1897- *Ein Beitrag zur angeborenen Stenose des Duodenums. 19p. 8? Bresl., G. Schenkalowsky, 1926. HEILINGBRUNNER, Franz Xaver, 1909- *Unterschenkelschaftfrakturen; ihre Behandlung und Heilung unter besonderer Berucksichtigung der verzogerten Heilung; Untersuchungen am Material der Chirurgischen Universitatsklinik in Munchen aus den Jahren 1918 bis 1932. 24p. 8? Miinch., Bayer. Dr. [1936] HEILINGBRUNNER, Max, 1904- *Ein Fall von Cylindrom der Xase. 24p. 8? Miinch., Bayer. Dr., 1932. HEILKENBRINKER, Maria, 1909- *Or- thopadische Versorgung schwerer angeborener Extremitatenmissbildungen [Freiburg] 27p. 21cm. Miinst., T. Brocker, 1936. HEILMANN, Albert, 1909- *Die ange- borenen Stenosen und Atresien des DarmkanaLs (mit einem eigenen Fall) [Heidelberg] 23p. 21 y2cm. Kaiserslautern, Thieme, 1935. HEILMANN, Albrecht, 1908- *Ueber die Altersstaroperationen der Jahrgange 1932 und 1933 an der Universitats-Augenklinik Wurzburg. 16p. 21cm. Wiirzb., Gebr. Memminger, 1936. HEILMANN, Claere, 1910- *Die sozialen Verhaltnisse der Wiirzburger Arbeitslosen und Kleinverdiener im Jahre 1935 [Wurzburg] 23p. 8° Gutersloh, Thiele [1936] HEILMANN, Emil, 1910- *Mischtu- moren der Mundhohle. 16p. pl. 22}<>cm. Wurzb., R. Mayr, 1938. HEILMANN, Josef, 1906- *Ueber Clu- pein und seine Bausteine [Miinchen] 23p. 8C Wurzb., R. Mayr, 1936. HEILMANN, Karl, 1906- *Der Komple- menttiter im menschlichen Blutserum bei In- fektions-Krankheiten, insbesondere bei Scharlach. 38p. 21cm. Bresl., K. Vater, 1936. HEILMANN, Karl, 1910- *Ueber die Regeneration des N. alveolaris inferior und superior nach Operationen und Traumen. 20p. 8? Lpz., A. Edelmann, 1933. HEILMEYER, Ludwig,1899- Medizinische bpektrophotometrie; ausgewahlte Methoden und neuere Untersuchungsergebnisse an Korper- tarbstoffen und Korperfliissigkeiten. xvi, 274n illust. 8? Jena, G. Fischer, 1933. TTu P*? Blut- P-l-75. 8? Jena, 1935. Jena" 11,3- SPGZ' P Physio1- (Becher, Bohnenkamp) See. also Errulat, Friedrich, Heilmeyer, Ludwig let all Physikalischei Methoden. Teil 2, 2. Hiilite. p.1691-2598. o. rSerl., lyol. —- & PLOETNER, Kurt. Das Serumeisen und die Eisenmangelkrankheit (Pathogenese Symptomatologie und Therapie) iv, 92n nl' tab. 8? Jena, G. Fischer, 1937. HEILPERN, Moses Josef, 1899- PORGES, Otto, & HOFFMANN, Herbert. Atlas der Gastrophotographie. vi, 29p. illust 38 pl. 8! Lpz., F. Deuticke, 1936. See also Uslenghi, J. P, Hofmann, H, & Heilpern, J La fotografia del est6mago. 215p. 23cm. B. Air, 1939. HEILPRIN, Louis. The historical reference book comprising a. chronological table of universal history: a chronological dictionary of universal history: a biographical dictionary. Rev. to 1899 6. ed. xi, 592p. 8? N. Y., D. Appleton, 1913. HEIM, Albert. Das Recht in der Kranken- pflege. p.322-68. 25^cm. Stuttg., Franckh'sche Verlagshandlung, 1939. In Hand- & Lehrb. Kr-ankenpfl. (X. Fischer [et al]) Bd 2 HEIM, Alfred [Ludwig] 1900- *Versuche mit Leron, einer siidamerikanischen Droge als Anthelminticum bei Fleischfressern [Munchen] 28p. 2 1. 8? Ludwigsb., K. Schahl, 1929. HEIM, Amanda, 1914- *Die Einwirkun- gen der gebrauchlichsten Zahnpasten auf den Zahnschmelz. 24p. 22cm. Wurzb., R. Mayr, 1938 HEIM, Ernst Ludwig, 1747-1834. Keszler, A. Der alte Heim; ein Familien- buch nach Briefen, Tagebuchaufzeichnungen, mundlicher und schriftlicher Ueberlieferung 201p. 8? Berl. [1932] Neee, A. Der alte Heim; ein Arzt; ein Christ; ein Charakterkopf in Anekdoten zusammen- gestellt. 90p. 12? Stuttg. [1924] Meyer, F. Ernst Ludwig Heim, ein moderner Arzt (1747- 1834) Ther. Gegenwart, 1933, 74: 304-10. HEIM, Erwin, 1908- *Ueber post- anginose Sepsis unter besonderer Beriicksichti- gung der in der Heidelberger Klinik beobachteten Falle [Heidelberg] 17p. 8? Coburg, Tagebl. Haus, 1934 HEIM, Gerhard, 1901- *Ist die Methode nach Gregersen zum Nachweis von Blut in den tierischen Faeces brauchbar? [Giessen] 26p. 8? Muhlhausen-T., R. Sayle, 1933. HEIM, Hellmut. Ueber den Bruch des Kahnbeins. 88p. 8? Berl., E. S. Mittler & Sohn, 1938. forms H. 29, Veroff. Marine San. HEIM, Karl, 1907- *Der Cholesteringe- halt des Blutes bei konstitutioneller Hyperten- sion, Diabetes mellitus und Adipositas [Tubin- gen] 31p. 8? Stuttg., E. Klett [1933] HEIM, Konrad, 1890- Die Frage nach dem Ursprung der endometrioiden Heterotopien beim geschlechtsreifen Weibe. HOp. 8 pl. 8? Berl., S. Karger, 1929. Forms II. 2, Abh. Geburtsh. HEIM, Ludwig, 1857- Kritzler-Kosch,H. [Biography] Deut. med. Wschr, 1934, GO: 1404; 1439.—Ludwig Heim zum 70. Coburtstage. Zbl. Bakt, 1. Abt, 1920-27, 101:457-60. HEIM, Paul, 1875-1929. Czerny. Nekrolog. Jahrb. Kinderh, 1929-30, 3. F, 76: 127.—Hainiss, E. Nekrolog. Mschr. Kinderh, 1929-30 45: p. ii-iv.—Muller, E. Nekrolog, Arch. Kinderh, 1929-30, 89: portr. HEIM HEIM, Wilhelm, 1906- *Untersuchungen iiber den klinischen Wert der Blutkorperchen- senkungsgeschwindigkeit fiir die Gynakologie [Berlin] 24p. S? Zeulenroda, A. Oberreuter, 1931. HEIM ANN, Gunther, 1908- *Ueber monamniotische Zwillinge mit ausgedehnten Nabelschnurverschlingungen. 19p. 22cm. Greifsw., H. Adler, 1936. HEIMANN, Guido. *Sur la teneur en gluco- side cyanhydrique des feuilles du laurier-cerise, du pecher et du sureau noir, dans ses rapports avec la lumiere et l'obscurite. 50p. 8? Strasb., Impr. C. Roch, 1933. HEIMANN, H. L., & WILSON, Dora. Nurses' pharmacopoeia and pocket book of useful ward information. 3. ed. vii, 70p. 32? Lond., Bailliere, Tindall & Cox, 1937. HEIMANN, Kurt, 1906- *Ueber einen Fall von Mikrognathie mit Trichterbrust und Deformierung der Extremitaten. 20p. pl. 8? Marb., Bauer, 1929. HEIMANN, Simon Alexander, 1900- *Spontane Harnblasenruptur nach Querschnitts- laesion des Riickenmarks. 21p. 8? Bresl. [n. pub.] 1925. HEIMANN, Violette, 1899- *Danger des mddicaments antisyphilitiques chez les rdnaux. 7Si>. 8? Par., A. Legrand, 1933. HEIM BACH, Andreas, 1913- *Entste- hung tuberkuloser Pleuraempyeme als Pneumo- thoraxkomplikation. 28p. 20J4cm. Bonn, H. Trapp, 1938. HEIMBERGER, Christina, 1903- *In- jektionsversuche an Katzen und Miiusen mit Vanadinsalzlosungen und Staubinhalationsver- suche an Katzen mit Vanadiumpentoxyd. 23p. 8? Wurzb., C. J. Becker, 1929. HEIMBROD, Fritz. La pyorrhee alveolo- dentairejson traitement par le stovarsol. 32p. 8? Geneve, Soc. Polygraph., 1925. HEIMBUECHEL, Wilhelm, 1893- *Ueber die antigenen Eigenschaften verschiedener siiure- fester Stabchen: Frosch-Schlangentuberkelbazil- len, Trompetenbazillen, gepriift am Meer- schweinchen mit den stammeseigenen Tuber- kulinen, mit bovinem, humanem und Schild- krotentuberkelbazillentuberkulin (Auszug) 6p. 8? Gics^n, O. Kindt, 1922. HEIM de BALSAC, Raymond, 1903- *Le sulfate neutre d'atropine en pathologie cardio- vasculaire et son application au diagnostic et au traitement des troubles fonctionnels du cceur. 226p. 2 pl. 8? Par., G. Doin & cie, 1927. HEIMEIER, Heinz, 1910- *Beitrag zur Behandlung der Pulpengangran und deren Folge- zustiinde [Munster] 24p. 8? Bottrop, W. Postberg, 1937. HEIMER, Hugo, 1914- *Inwiefern be- stimmt das Rontgenbild bei chronisch granulie- renden Periodontitiden unser Handeln und be- grenzt die Massnahmen unserer conservierenden Therapie? 49p pl. tab. 8? Bonn, J. Duck- witz, 1937. HEIMERICH, Hermann, 1909- *Keim- gehalt und Entkeimungsmoglichkeiten der Zahn- btirste. 22p. 21]2cm. Marb., A. Zeil, 1936. HEIMERL, Martin, 1898- '"Untersuchun- gen iiber die Wirksamkeit und Beschaffenheit von Zahnpasten und Zahnpulvern. 20p. pl. 8? P>lanjen, Hofer & Limmert, 1927. HEIM-GREIF, Irene, 1914- *Die Ver- letzung des medialen Kniej/relenkseitenbandes [Bern] lop. 21cm, Pfan kirchen, Kambli, 1940. 4 HEIMLICH HEIMLICH, Erika, 1906- *Raumbe- entrende Prozesse in der hinteren Schadclgrube p.241-54. 8? Jena [n. pub.] 1930. Also Arch. Psychiat, Berl, 1931, 93: HEIMLICH, Helmut, 1907- *Sitzende Berufstatigkeit und Erkrankungen der weiblichen Geschlechtsorgane [Breslau] 2-1 p. 8? Guters- loh, Thiele, 1934. HEIMPRECHT, Hugo, 1910- *lYbcrdic Zunahme der Extrauteringraviditat wahrend des letzten Jahre und deren Ursache [Heidelberg] lip. 8? Coburg, Tagebl. Haus, 1935. HEIMS-HEYMANN, Paul. Sec Heymann-Heims. HEIMSOTH, Karl Gunther, 1899- *He- tero- und Homophilie; eine neuorientierende An- und Einordnung der Erscheinungsbilder der Hoinosexualitat und der Inversion in Beriick- sichtigung der sogenannten normalen Freund- schaft auf Grund der zwei verschiedenen erotischen Anziehungsgesetze und der bisexuellen Grund- einstellung des Mannes [Rostock] 33p. 8? Dortmund, Schmidt & Andernach, 1925. HE1M-VOEGTLIN, Marie, 1845-1916. Siebel, C. Das Leben von Frau Marie Heim- Vogtlin der ersten Schweizer Aerztin, 1845-1916. 296 p. 9 pl. 12? Ziir., Pascher & cie, 1919. HEIN, Berthold, 1910- *Beziehungen zwischen Dermographia rubra und peripherer Durchblutung [Wiirzburg] 19p. 21^cm. Forchheim (Ofr.) O. Mauser, 1937. HEIN, Emil E., 1891-1940. Moore, N. S. [Obituary] Week. Bull. S. Louis M. Soc, 1940-41, 35: 427. HEIN, Gunther, 1905- *Der Volvulus ventriculi und seine differential-diagnostischen Schvvierigkeiten [Munster] 29p. 8? Quaken- bruck, R. Kleinert, 1930. HEIN [Hans] Friedrich, 1908- *Ueber stielgedrehte Hydrosalpinx. 32p. 8? Marb., J. Hamel, 1935. HEIN, Hellmut, 1906- *Beziehungen zwischen Silikose und Paradentose. 20p. 8? Munch., C. Wolf & Sohn, 1936. HEIN, J. Die Thorakoplastik. p.711-1062. 27cm. Lpz., G. Thieme, 1938. In Kollapsther. Lungentuberk. (W. Schmidt) HEIN, Michaela, 1909- *Ueber Spatge- burten (ein Beitrag zur Frage der Schwanger- schaftsdauer) [Gottingen] 41p. 22cm. Ratibor, Oberschles. Ges. Dr., 1935. HEIN, Richard James, 1911- "The care and management of immature infants. 32p. 4? Tacoma [n. pub.] 1938. Typewritten. HEIN, Stephan, 1910- *Ueber die Bezie- hungen der einfachen achlorhydrischen Anamie zur Biermerschen Anamie an Hand von 20 in der Medizinischen Universitats-Poliklinik zu Breslau beobachteten Fallen. 39p. 8? Bresl., R. Nischkowsky, 1938. HEINAENEN, Niilo. *Ueber die Ergebnisse der internen Behandlung der Ulkuskrankheit. 178p. 8? Helsin. [n. pub.] 1938. Also Acta Soc. med. Duodecim, 1938, ser. B, 25: HEINE, Bernhard, 1864-1928. Claus, H. Nekrolog. Beitr. Anat. Ohr, 1928, 27: 203 — Haymann, L. Nekrolog. Miinch. med. Wschr, 1928, 75: SHI portr.—Herzog, H. Nekrolog. Zschr. Hals Ac. Heilk, 1928, 22: 229-32.— Nadoleczny. Nekrolog. Deut. med. Wschr, 1928, 54: 887.—Voss, O. Nekrolog. Arch. Ohr. Ac. Heilk, 1928 118: p. i-iii. HEINE, Bodo, 1909- *Heinrich August Wrisberg's Bedeutung fiir die Pathologie (1736- I8O81. 23p. 21cm. Gott., Erbs & Meisel, 1935. HEINE 445 HEINEL HEINE, Elisabeth, 1910- *Die Ver- vollstandigung der gynakologischen Diagnostik durch die Hystero-Salpingographie, gezeigt an Fallen eines Jahres der Universitats-Frauen- klinik zu Kiel [Kiel] 19p. 23^cm. Parahyba D/N. [n. pub.] 1936. HEINE, Ernst Edmund, 1906- *Schicksal und Lebenswert friihgeborener Kinder [Leipzig] 20p. 8? Zeulenroda, A. Oberreuter, 1937. HEINE [Friedrich] Wilhelm, 1905- *Zur Tonsillentuberkulose des Rindes. 27p. 8? Giessen, A. Muller, 1933. HEINE, Fritz, 1871- *Ueber die Gah- rungsverhaltnisse der Faeces. 28p. 8? Bonn, A. Henry, 1896. HEINE, Hans Heinrich, 1901- *Be- merkungen zur Histologie und pathologischen Anatomie des Ostium pharyngeum Tubae Eustachii [Berlin] 17p. 8? Miinch. [n. pub.] 1927. HEINE, Hans Joachim [Walter Rudolf] 1913- *Blutsenkung bei Leberkrankheiten [Bres- lau] 31p. tab. 8? Waldenb.-Schl. [n. pub.] 1938. HEINE, Heinrich, 1799-1856. Cohn, M. War Heinrich Heine infiziert? Zschr. Sex wiss, 1930-31, 17: 431-7.—Haberling, W. Heinrich Heine's medical ancestors and relatives. Med. Life, N. Y, 1934, 41: 42-8, pl, 3 portr.—Wyatt, F. A case of prediction over a century; Heine on the national-socialist revolution. J. Abnorm. Psychol, 1941, 36: 583-8. HEINE, Josef, 1895- Ueber die Appendi- citis bei Chinesen. 40p. 8? Lpz., J. A. Barth, 1930. Forms Beiheft 1, v.34, Arch. Schiffs Tropenhyg. HEINE, Johann Georg, 1770-1838. Hohmann, G. [Biography] Miinch. med. Wschr, 1929 76: 2056-8. HEINE [Leopold, 1870- ] Anleitung zur Augenuntersuchung bei Allgemeinerkrankungen. 3. Aufl. xii, 154p. 8? Jena, G. Fischer, 1919. Also 4. Aufl. xii, 154p. 1924. ---Die Krankheiten des Auges, im Zusam- menhang mit der inneren Medizin und Kinder- heilkunde. xix, 540p. 8? Berl., J. Springer, 1921. Forms Spez. Teil Enzykl. klin. Med. (Langstein, von Noorden [et al] ---Ueber Haftglaser. 32p. 8? Stuttg., F. Enke, 1933. Forms Beiheft 91, Klin. Mbl. Augenh. HEINE, Maria, 1910- *Die zahniirztliche Versorgung der Provinzen Nieder- und Ober- schlesien unter besonderer Berucksichtigung der Leistungen der offentlichen Fiirsorge [Munster] 23p. 8? Wertheim, E. Bechstein, 1934. HEINE, Maurice. Recueil de confessions et observations psycho-sexuelles. xxiii, 269p. pl. 8? Par., J. Cres, 1936. HEINE, Richard, 1905- *Ueber Horn- hautveranderungen wahrend der Schwanger- schaft [Leipzig] 15p. pl. 8? [Zeulenrode, A. Oberreuter] 1920. HEINE, Walter, 1912- *Ueber Milz- rupturen. 25p. 8? Berl., R. Pfau, 1937. HEINE, Wilhelm, 1908- *Zur Wirkung des Suprarenins auf die Erythrocyten und Thrombocyten im Blut bei Milztumoren [Wiirz- burg] 24p. 2 tab. 8? Wertheim, E. Bechstein, 1934. HEINECKE, Karl, 1906- *Plattfuss- Statistik (Dargestellt an dem Krankenmaterial der Orthopadischen Universitatsklinik zu Berlin aus den Jahren 1926-28) 38p. 8? Berl., R. Pfau, 1933. HEINEL, Friedrich Hermann, 1900- *Das Verhaltnis der kindlichen Mortalitat bei Wach- und Scopolamindammerschlaf-Geburten (Universitats-Frauenklinik Wurzburg, 1913-19) Wurzburg] 54p. 8? Lpz., Breitkopf & Hartel lyzb. HEINEMANN, Alfred, 1907- *Zur Ka- suistik branchiogener Bildungen; Struma post- branchiahs und retrosternale Plattenepithel- zellencyste. 23p. 8? Heidelb., Bechstein, iyoi. HEINEMANN, Bernhard, 1898- *Ein historischer Ueberblick uber die Therapie der Knochenbriiche. 65p. 8? Bonn, A. Brand, 1937 HEINEMANN, Christian, 1909- *Ueber einen Fall von angeborener Wabenlunge bedingt durch fetale Bronchiektasien. 27p. pl. 22^cm Marb., H. Bauer, 1936. HEINEMANN, Ernst [August] 1912- *Ueber typhose Knochenkomplikationen, insbe- sondere an den Rippen, und ihre Behandlung 43p. 20^cm. K6nigsb.-Pr., J. Raabe, 1936. HEINEMANN [Ernst Otto] Werner, 1912- *Ueber die Resorption der Losungen von Na- trium- und Kaliumsulfat und Kaliumchlorid im Dunndarm. 19p. 8? Lpz., A. Edelmann, 1937. HEINEMANN, Gerhard, 1911- *Ueber die Geschmackswirkung von anorganischen Dop- pelsalzen; II [Jena] 28p. 8? Stadtroda, E. & E. Richter, 1937. HEINEMANN, Hans Georg, 1906- *An der Rostocker Universitats-Frauenklinik beob- achtete Perforationen des graviden Uterus bei Abortausraumung (1920-30) [Rostock] 31p. 8? Wanzleben, A. Schulz [1931] HEINEMANN, Heinrich, 1900- *Der Schienenhulsenapparat und seine Indikation bei Kriegsbeschadigten. 23p. 23cm. Lpz., Radelli & Hille, 1936. HEINEMANN, Herbert, 1904- *Beitrag zur Kenntnis der sublingualen Fibrome. 16p. 8? Munster, C. J. Fahle, 1933. HEINEMANN, Johannes August, 1902- *Ueber Beziehungen zwischen Durchsichtigkeit der Linse zur Entwicklung der senilen Erkran- kung der Netzhautmitte. lip. 8? Wiirzb., C. J. Becker, 1930. HEINEMANN, Joseph, 1895- *Beitrag zur Geschichte der Erkennung, Aetiologie und Therapie der Steingalle (Ausz^ig) [Leipzig) 8p. 8? [Bad DribUrg, H. Gemiingt] 1923. HEINEMANN, Oscar. Die Wurzelfullung; Leitfaden fiir die Behandlung pulpakranker und pulpaloser Zahne. 2 p. 1. lOOp. 8? Berl., H. Meusser, 1926. HEINEMANN, Paul, 1907- *Odontogene Arthritiden. 20p. 8? Berl. [n. pub.] 1933. HEINEMANN, Udo, 1911- *Ueber Ova- rialgeschwulste bei Kindern mit Bericht iiber einen Fall von Polycystadenoma: pseudomu- cinosum permagnum bei einem 12 jahrigen Madchen. 24p. 8? Erlangen, K. Dores, 1936. HEINEMANN, Werner, 1912- *Die Wirkung des Cardiazols auf das Reizbildungs- und Reizleitungssystem des Herzens. 25p. 20>km. K6nigsb.-Pr., J. Raabe, 1937. HEINEMANN, Wolfgang, 1911- *Ueber den Einfluss von Siiuren und Alkalien auf die Verdauungsalkalose beim Menschen. 31p. 21cm. Jena, G. Neuenhahn, 1937. HEINE-MEDIN'S disease. See Infantile paralysis. HEINEMEIER, Martin, 1899- *Ein Beitrag zur Frage des Zusammenwirkens der Hormone (Thyroxin und Prolan im Ascherschen HEINEMEIER Sauorstoffmangelversuch) 46p. 8? Kiel, Schmidt & Klaunig, 1933. HEINEN, Fritz, 1908- *Untersuchungen iiber Reticulocyten [Miinchen] 24p. 8? Zeu- lenroda, B. Sporn, 1935. HEINEN, Martin, 1901- *Die Hand- schrift bei Manisch-Depressiven. 36p. 8? Bonn, H. Trapp, 1928. HEINEN, Walter, 1909- *Beitrag zur Kasuistik des Myxofibromas. 24p. 21cm. Bonn, A. Brand, 1937. HEINERMANN, Egon, 1911- *Das Ektropium uveae congenitum mit angeborenem Buphthalmus. 19p. 8? Wiirzb., R. Mavr, 1936. HEINERSDORFF, Hans Gerd, 1907- *Zur Mediastinographie und kunstlichen Fixa- tion des vorderen Mittelfelles [Freiburg] lip. 24cm. Berl., L. Schumacher, 1936. Also Beitr. klin. Chir, 1936, 164: HEINERT, Gerhard, 1909- *Ueber die mikroskopische Keimzahlbestimmung in der Milch. 49p. 21cm. Lpz., A. Edelmann, 1936. HEINEVETTER, Ursula, 1911- *Ueber zahnarztlich-chirurgische Eingriffe wahrend der Graviditas 25p. "22J/2cm. Wiirzb., It. Mayr, 1936. HEINGARTER, Conrad, fl. 1480. Thorndike. 1, Conrad Hcingartcr in Zurich manuscripts, especially- lis medical advice to the Duchess of Bourbon. Bull. Insi. 11 i-t;_ M, Bait. 1930, 4: 81-7. IIEINHAUS, Hildegard, 1906- *Bak- teriologie der Paradentose [Heidelberg] 29p. 8? Walldorf, Fr. Lamade, 1929. HEINHOLD, Lothar, 1902- *Das weisse Blutbild bei Ekzema vaccinatum (an Hand von drei Fallen) 22p. 8? Freib. i. B., K. Henn, 1931. HEINICHEN, Kurt, 1903- *Harnblasen- divertikel unter besonderer Beriicksichtigung eigener Beobachtungen [Jena] 22p. 3 1. 8? Borna, R. Noske, 1929. HEINICKE, Arthur John, 1892- Factors influencing catalase activity in apple-leaf tissue. 19p. 8? Ithaca, N. Y., 1923. Forms No. 62, Mem. Cornel) Lniv. Agr. Exp. Sta. ----Catalase activity in dormant apple twigs: its relation to the condition of the tissue, respiration, and other factors. 33p. 8? Ithaca, N. Y., 1924. Forms Xo. 74, Mem. Cornell Univ. Agr. Exp. Sta. HEINICKE, Elfriede [Erika] 1909- *Hi- stologische Veranderungen an retinierten Zahnen. 20p. 8? Lpz. [n. pub.] 1933. HEINIG [Ernst Max] Alfred, 1910- *Die Pathogenese der Pyelonephritis bacterica der Rinder. 40p. 21cm. Lpz., A. Pries, 1936. HEINIS. Fritz. *Zur Histogenese retroperi- tonealer Karzinome [Basel] 32p. pl. 23cm. Liestal, LiidirT& co., 1938. HEINKE, Ernst, 1912- *Verwendungs- moglichkeiten und Leistungen der Kalten Quarz- lampe (Hanau) in der Behandlung von Kiefer- erkrankungen [Berlin] 31p. 21cm. Gutersloh, Thiele, 1938. HEINKE, Fritz Heinrich, 1909- *Das Plantschbecken; seine hygienische Einrichtung und Betreuung [Frankfurt] 22p. 21cm. Dresd M. Dittert & co., 1939. HEINKEL, Friedrich, 1910- *Ein Beitrag zur intravitalen und postmortalen Diagnostik der Hundetuberkulose [Leipzig] 37p. 8° Blaubeuren, K. Hohn, 1933. HEINKELE, Alfred, 1905- *Hemi- opisthotoxon, eine Wirbelmissbildung [Munster] 21 p. 8? Quakenbruck, R. Kleinert, 1932. IIEINKEN HEINKEN, Georg, 1912 *Praktisclie Untersuchungen von Methoden, die zur Bc- licbung der Goldkontraktion empfohlcn werden 3Sp. 8? Weende, F. Pieper, 1936. HEINLE, Hedwig, 1911- * Ueber odonto- gen und artificiell entstandene Osteomyelitis des Oberkiel'ers [Munchen] 16p. 8°. Wiirzb It. Mayr, 1934. HEINLEIN, Julia Heil, 1895- Prefer- ential manipulation in children. 121p. 8C Bait., 1930. Forms No. 33, v. 7, Comp. Psychol. Monogr. HEINLEIN, Martin, 1910- *Die Hy- dronephrose im Kindesalter. 31p. 8? Berl, Xeuland, 1937. HEINLEIN, Wolfgang Dietrich, 1908- *Johann Lukas Boer, der Begriinder der natiir- lichen Geburtshilfe (1751-1825) 26p. 23>/2cm. Wiirzb., Gebr. Memminger, 1935. HEINONEN, Oskar. *Kliniska undersoknin- gar rorande nassjukdomarnas och nagra dis- ponerande moments betydelse i dacryostenosens etiologi [Helsingfors] 178p. 8? Abo [n. pub.] 1920. HEINRICH, Arthur, 1909- *Bestehen Beziehungen in der Abhangigkeit hartnackig positiver Wassermann-Reaktionen im Blute und Liquorveriinderungen [Munchen] 16p. 8? Wiirzb., R. Mayr, 1933. HEINRICH, Carl, 1880- The cactus- feeding Phycitinae: a contribution toward a revision of the American pyralidoid moths of the family Phycitidae. p.331-413. 29 pl. 8? Wash., 1939. Forms No. 3053, v.86, Proc. U. S. Nat. Mus. HEINRICH, Curt, 1885- Die Lehre vom Star bei Georg Bartisch (1533-1606) 43p. pl. 8? Jena, G. Fischer, 1916. Forms Heft fi, Jena. med. hist. Beitr. (T. Meyer-Steineg) HEINRICH,Erich, 1895- Unsere Patien- ten und wir; psychologische Grundlagen und ihre praktische Auswertung fiir den Erfolg in der zahnarztlichen Praxis. 2. Aufl. 170p. illust. diagrs. tab. 8? Munch., J. F. Lehmann [1933] —— Biologische Therapie in der Zahnheil- kunde. 2 1. viii, 226p. 8? Berl., Berlin. Verlagsanstalt, 1935. ---- Zahnarztliche Beruf skunde; Wesen, Grundlagen, Voraussetzungen, Berufswahl, Be- rufseignungspriifungen. 142p. illust. diagrs. 8? Miinch., J. F. Lehmann [1935] ---- Die Helferin des Zahnarztes; ein Lehr- und Nachschlagebuch. 2. Aufl. [12] 154p. illust. 8? Berl., Berlin. Verlagsanstalt, 1936. ---- Rationelles Arbeiten in der Zahnheil- kunde; ein Beitrag zur Minderung des Auf- wandes an Arbeit, Zeit und Geld, xvi, 290p. illust. 24}2cm. Berl., Berlin. Verlagsanstalt, 1938. * ----Die medikamentos-chirurgische Para- dentosetherapie; Gesamtdarstellung und Bericht iiber Erfolge und Misserfolge. viii, 191p. illust. 24>/2cm. Berl., Berlin. Verlagsanstalt, 1939. Also editor of Deutsches Zahnarzte-Buch. 18. Ausg, 1935 629p. 8? Berl, 1035. HEINRICH, Erwin, 1911- *Ueber die sozialhygienische Bedeutung der Stadtrand- siedlung mit besonderer Berucksichtigung der Siedlung Klein-Masselwitz. 24p. 21cm. Bresl., P. Plischke, 1937-38. HEINRICH, Eugen, 1904- *Was sagt die Literatur uber die Beziehungen zwischen Ernahrung und Zahnen, insbesondere iiber die Einstellung der Heilkunde zu diesem Problem, HEINRICH 447 HEINRICH und inwieweit hat die Ernahrungswissenschaft in der Praxis zu greifbaren Resultaten gefiihrt? 72p. 8? Bonn, L. Heidelmann, 1935. HEINRICH, Ferdinand, 1905- *Das Wachstum der menschlichen Gesichtsschadels von der Kindheit bis ins Alter [Munchen] 17p. 8? Diisseld., G. H. Nolte, 1936. HEINRICH, Friedrich, 1910- *Ueber den Ersatz des Ductus choledochus. 52p. 8? Bonn, H. Trapp, 1935. HEINRICH, Fritz. Ein mittelenglisches Medi- zinbuch. 234p. 8? Halle, M. Niemeyer, 1896. Microfilm copy. HEINRICH, Hans, 1910- *Ueber Haufig- keit und Beziehungen des Kindbettfiebers in der ostpreussischen Hebammenpraxis. 24p. ch. 8? Konigsb. Pr., E. Rautenberg, 1937. HEINRICH, Helmut, 1907- lnter- suchungen iiber die cyklischen Veranderungen in Vagina und Cervix bei Affen (Macacus brevi- caudus) [Berlin] 30p. 8? Gutersloh, Thiele, 1935. HEINRICH, Herbert William, 1886- Industrial accident prevention; a scientific approach. 2. ed., 2. impression. • xii, 448p. 201/2cm. N. Y., McGraw-Hill book co., 1941. HEINRICH [Horst Kurt] Edgar, 1907- *Ueber Dien-Synthesen des a-Methyl-indols und des N, a-Dimethyl-indols [Kiel] 27p. 8? Borna, R. Noske, 1932. HEINRICH, Ingeborg [Minna Marie] 1900- *Ueber den Lupus vulgaris und seine Behandlung. 64p. 8? [Berl., n. pub.] 1930. HEINRICH, Josephus. *De quibusdam phar- macis recentioribus [Wien] 40p. 21cm. Wien, Tvpogr. Mechitaristica, 1841. HEINRICH, Julius, 1888- *Ueber Kon- krementbildung in Speicheldrlisen. 14p. 8? Wurzb., K. Triltsch, 1926. HEINRICH, Kurt, 1907- *Beitrag zur Kenntnis der Recklinghausen'schen Krankheit. 36p. 8? Berl., E. Ebering, 1935. HEINRICH, Kurt, 1908- *Der komplette Dammriss mit besonderer Berucksichtigung der Spatfolgen; eine klinische Studie auf Grund von 62 Fallen der Wiirzburger Universitats-Frauen- klinik aus den Jahren 1912-1930' [Wurzburg] 15p. 3 tab. 8? Coburg, Tagebl. Haus, 1934. HEINRICH, Kurt [Walter Helmut] 1911- *Der Einfluss der Digitalis auf das Elektro- kardiogramm des gesunden und kranken mensch- lichen Herzens [Breslau] 20p. 22}4cm. Liebau, H. Hiltmann, 1936. HEINRICH, Meta, 1911- *Ein Beitrag zur Frage der Anerkennung des Morphinismus als Unfallfolge [Munster] 16p. 203/2cm. Werne a. d. Lippe, F. Grube, 1937. HEINRICH [Philipp Joseph] Georg, 1907- *Die Ursachen der Leistenbruchrezidive. 23p. 8? Frankf. a. M. [n. pub., 1934] HEINRICH, R. Beitrage zur Theorie des Schlafes und zur ursachlichen Behandlung der Storungen des Schlafes. 41p. 8? Munch., 0. Gmelin, 1919. HEINRICH, Richard [Friedrich Augustl 1893- *Zur Differentialdiagnose zwischen Hirn- tumor und Encephalitis epidemica; mit einem kasuistischen Beitrag und einer Zusammenstel- lung einschlagiger Falle der Literatur [Konigs- berg] p.643-62. 8? Berl., J. Springer, 1926. Also Arch. Psychiat, 1926, 78: HEINRICH, Ursula, 1912- *Ueber den Cholesteringehalt im Blut bei der Otosklerose. 27p. 8? Bresl. [n. pub.] 1938. HEINRICH, Waldemar, 1900- *Parotitis epidemica, eine Periglandulitis epidemica; in- wieweit entspricht der Begriff Parotitis epi- demica den gegenwartigen Vorstellungen und Kenntnissen vom Wesen dieser Krankheit? LGreifswald] 15p. 20^cm. Berl. [n. pub.] HEINRICH, Werner, 1905- *Ueber Wirkungsbedingungen der Analeptica. p.357- 66 8? Konigsb. i. Pr., J. Raabe, 1931. Also Arch. exp. Path, 1931, 151: HEINRICHER, E[mil] 1856- Was alles aus der Nachkommenschaft einer Pflanze her- vprgehen kann (Studien zur Art- und Form- bildung an Kulturen von Primula kewensis, 1925-33) 60p. pl. 4? Berl. (1933) 1934. Forms Heft 1, Abh. Pi cuss. Akad. Wiss., phvs. math. Kl. HEINRICHS, Paul Wilhelm, 1898- *Ex- perimentelle Untersuchungen iiber die Bezie- hungen der Thymusdruse zu den Speicheldriisen. 15p. 8? [Wurzb., n. pub., 1925] HEINRICHS, Siegfried, 1908- *.Ueber die elektrische Erregbarkeit der sensiblen Haut- nerven bei percutaner und intracutaner Priifung. p. 191-7. 8? Bonn [n. pub.] 1933. HEINRICHS, Waltraut, 1909- *Ueber Beeinflussung des Sarkomstoffwechsels durch Hormone. 14p. 8? Konigsb. i. Pr., J. Raabe, 1933. HEINRICI, Gerda Steffi Edith, 1913- *Kosmetik des Mundes. 22p. 22cm. Lpz., G. Becher, 1936. HEINRICIUKSEN, Gustaf, 1853-1915. Siirala, M. |Activity of Prof. Gustaf Heinrieiuksen in the Viipuri Student Society during his student davs 1.871-1882] Duodecim, Helsin, 1937, 53: 150-04. HEINRITZ, Rudolf, 1911- *Eine Schnell- methode der Untersuchung des Nasen-Rachen- raumes auf Diphtheriestabchen [Wurzburg] 20p. 8? Bleicherode, C. Nieft, 1937. HEINROTH, Johann Christian August, 1773- 1843. Jelliffe, S. E. [Biography] Ment. Hyg, Alb, 1930, 14: No. 2, portr. HEINROTH, Oskar, 1871- Koehler, O. Oskar Heinroth zum 70. Geburtstage. Natur- wissenschaften, 1941, 29: 169-71. HEINS, Erich, 1909- *Allergische Haut- erkrankungen in Beziehung zur Einwirkung organischer Chemikalien. 39p. 8? Berl. [n. pub.] 1931. HEINS, Hans, 1911- *Experimentelle Untersuchungen iiber den Einfluss von Folli- kelhormon auf die Regeneration der glatten Muskulatur des Rattenuterus und Ratten- magens [Kiel] 16p. 22}£cm. Marb., H. Bauer, 1935. HEINS, Liihr Georg, 1905- *Exstirpa- tion des Uterus wegen schwerster Geburts- und Abortusblutungen. 44p. 8? Marb., J. Hamel, 1931. HEINSEN, Heinz-Adolf. *Zur Frage der Herkunft und Histogenese der Struma ovarii. 15p. 8? [n. p., n. pub., 1931] Also Virchows Arch, 1032, 284: 234-48. ---- *Ketonkorperbildung aus Aminosauren [Habilitationsschrift; Giessen] p.672-701. 24cm. Wurzb., H. Stiirtz, 1938. Also Erg. inn. Med. Kinderh, 1938, 54: HEINSIUS, Ernst [Fritz Paul August] 1906- *Ueber kleinste Aderhautsarkome. p.468- 86. 8? Berl., J. Springer, 1931. Also Arch. Ophth, 1931, 127: HEINTZ [Albert] Erich, 1905- Ver- gleichende Untersuchungen zur Desinfektions- wirkung des Leukotropins und seiner Einzel- HEINTZ 448 HEISCHKEL komponenten. 55p. 8? Bonn, P. Kubens, 1934. HEINTZ, Kurt [Heinrich] 1902- *Frei- heitsberaubung durch Einweisung bzw. Fcst- haltung in Irrenanstalten. 66p. S° Bonn, P. Kubens, 1930. HEINTZE-MEYER, Erwin, 1910- *Die Cutanreaktion bei der Gonorrhoe der Frau [Breslau] 23p. 22J^cm. Liebau, H. Hiltmann, 1936. HEINZ, Curt, 1904- *Ueber die Beein- flussung der Hautresorption durch Kohlensaure. 30p. 8? Marb., Bauer, 1932. HEINZ (H. J.) Co. Research Department. Nutritional charts, prepared expressly for medi- cal, dental and dietetic specialists. 23p. ch. obi. 4? [Pittsb.] 1934. Also 9. ed. 36p. incl. tab. 1940. HEINZ, Joseph, 1899- *Ueber Knorpel- und Knocheneinlagerungen in den Gaumen- mandeln [Frankfurt a. M.] p.160-78. 8? Lpz., C. Kabitzsch, 1929. HEINZ, Karl, 1908- *Die pathogene- tische Bedeutung der Enterokokken [Heidel- bergl 16p. 8? Giitersloh, Thiele, 1935. HEINZ, Otto, 1906- *Ueber ein odonto- genes Psammokarzinom des Oberkiefers im Bereich des retinierten dritten Molaren. p.625- 36. 8? Marb. [n. pub.] 1932. Also Deut,. Mschr. Zahnh, 1932, 50: HEINZE, Alfred, 1909- *Ueber den Einfluss embryonalen Gewebes auf die Ge- schwulstimmunitat [Berlin] 18p. 8? Kirchhain, M. Schmersow, 1936. HEINZE, Alfred [Oskar] 1911- *Beitrag zur Kenntnis der Conjunctivitis cystica (foUi- cularis) des Hundes [Leipzig] 35p. 8? Gross- Schonau, H. Engelhardt, 1937. HEINZE, E[rnst] 1907- * Leber den Verlauf der juvenilen Paralvse nach Malariabe- handlung. p.84-101. 8? " Berl., E. Ebering, 1935. Also Abh. Neur. Psychiat, 1932, No. 0. HEINZE, Hans [Bruno] 1895- ♦Ver- anderungen des Liquor cerebrospinalis und ihre Bedeutung fiir die Auffassung vom Wesen der Ischias. 36p. 8? Lpz., F. C. Vogel, 1923. HEINZE, Karl, 1910- *Gaumenspalten- operationen mit besonderer Berucksichtigung der Erfolge an der Heidelberger Chirurgischen Klinik in den Jahren 1934-35 [Heidelberg] 12p. 8? Eichsfeld, W. Kolditz, 1938. HEINZE [Karl] H[ugo] 1871- *Ueber Odontome und ein ahnliches Gebilde [Kiel] 36p. 8? Miinst. i. W., J. Krick, 1926. HEINZEL, Heinrich, 1911- *Ueber das Krankheitsbild der Arthritis gonorrhoica [Munchen] 19p. 21cm. Gunzburg, K. Mayer, 1938. HEINZELMANN, Hildegard. *Ueber den Einfluss der Thorakocentese auf den Ablauf des kindlichen Empyems [Breslau] 15p. 8? Lieg- nitz, E. Wagner, 1936. HEINZELMANN, Lore, 1909- *Ueber Endokarditis bei Miliartuberkulose [Tubingen] 16p. 8? Metzingen (Wiirtt.) E. Franz, 1934. HEINZELMANN, Rudolf, 1911- *Ueber Adamantinome. 27p. 8? Miinch., Hohenhaus, 1936. HEINZERLING, Edna L. Editor of Wyche, M. L. The history of nursing in North Carolina. 151p. 22cm. Chapel Hill, 1938. HEIPP, Edwin A[lbert] 1910- *Rupture of the uterus [St Joseph's Hosp.] 21 1. 28cm Milwaukee, 1939. Typewritten. HEISCHKEL, Edith. *Die Medizingeschicht- schreibung von ihren Anfiingen bis zum Beginn des 16. Jahrhunderts. 91p. pl. 23}.cm. Berl E. Eberling, 1938. ----Die Medizinhistoriographie im XVIII. Jahrhundert. 2 p. 1. 65p. 8? Leiden, E. J Brill, 1931. Sec also Diepgen, Paul & Heisthkel, Edith. Die Medizin an der Berliner Charite. 185p. 8? Berl, 1935. ♦Ueber die Sub- 8? Wurzb., H. HEISE, Erich, 1899- pektoralphlegmone. 16p Stiirtz, 1926. HEISE, Fred Henry, 1883- See Brown, Lawrason, & Heise, Fred Henry. The lungs and the early stages of tuberculosis. 151p. 8? N. Y, 1931. HEISE, Otto, 1909- *Untersuchungen iiber den Einfluss des Ostseeklimas auf allergische Hautreaktionen [Rostock] 15p. 8? Jena, G. Neuenhahn, 1934. HEISE, Paul. *Heparin; its clinical use [Harper Hosp.] 15 1. 28cm. Detr., 1941. Typewritten. HEISE, Rudolf, 1908- *Histaminbildung durch tierisches Gewebe [Greifswald] 16p. 21cm. Lengerich, Lengerich. Handelsdr., 1937. HEISE, Walter, 1899- *Untersuchungen iiber lokalen Warmereiz und umschriebene Schweissekretion. 14p. 8? Frankf. a. M. [n. pub.] 1919. HEISE, Werner, 1912- *Histologische Untersuchungen der Schmelzpulpa. 20p. 2 pl. 8? Wiirzb., M. Hofmann, 1935. HEISELBECK, Naftali. *Ein Fall von Morbus Addisoni mit voriibergehender Besserung. 16p. 8? Zur., H. Hasch, 1929. HEISER, Use, 1910- *Mikroelasto- metrische Untersuchungen an klinisch normalen Zahnen im Vergleich zu Messungen an ideal- idastischem Federstahlband. 26p. 8? Halle, E. Klinz, 1935. HEISER, Victor George, 1873- An American doctor's Odyssey, viii, 544p. portr. 8? N. Y., W. W. Norton & co. [1936] ---- You're the doctor. 3. impr. 300p. 21cm. N. Y., W. W. Norton & co. [1939] ---- Toughen up, America! vii, 228p. 21cm. N. Y., McGraw-Hill book co. [1941] HEISERMANN, Karl Franz, 1889- ♦Ueber den Lupus erythematodes und seine Be- handlung mit Gold. 28p. 8? Marb. [n. pub.] 1926. HEISIG, Franz [Karl Maria Anton] 1898- *Zur Kasuistik der Aorten- und Herzrupturen [Breslau] 39p. 8? Schmiedeberg, A. Kah, 1926. HEISIG, Hellmuth, 1905- ♦Untersu- chungen uber die Gaumenspaltensprache, ihre Therapie nach Gutzmann, Hermann und Engel [Gottingen] 32p. 8? Osnabruck, Meinders & Elstermann, 1930. HEISIG, Kurt, 1908- *Ueber die Klinik der Pityriasis lichenoides chronica unter be- sonderer Berucksichtigung der atypischen For- men. 35p. 8? Berl., R. Pfau, 1934. HEISIG, Walter, 1907- *Zur Frage der immunbiologischen Sonderstellung der Haut- tuberkulose (Nathan und Kall6s) 20p. 23cm. Greifsw., E. Panzig & co., 1935. HEISING [Ernst] Konrad [Max] 1907- *Besteht bei Placenta-praevia-Neugeborenen eine nachweisbare Anamie? [Konigsberg] p. 1691-9. 8? Lpz., J. A. Barth, 1935. Also Zbl Gyn, 1935, 59: HEISING, Helmut, 1910- * Beitrag zur Klinik und Elektrokardiographie des Herzblocks [Konigsberg] 47p. 8? Bethel-Bielefeld [n. pub.] 1936. HEISING HEISING, Laurenz, 1902- ♦Ueber die Form der Aufmerksamkeitsspaltung [Rostock] 32p. 8? Borna, R. Noske, 1931. HEISING, Wilderich, 1904- *Bericht uber die Falle von perforierten Magen- und Duodenalgeschwtiren der Chirurgischen Uni- versitatsklinik Bonn und des St Johannis- hospitals Bonn von 1920 bis 1930. 23p. 8? Bonn, H. Trapp, 1930. HEISLER, August, 1881- Dennoch Land- arzt' Erfahrungen und Betrachtungen aus der Praxis. 2. Aufl. 229p. 8? Munch., O. Gmelin, 1933. ---- Landarzt und Naturheilverfahren. 3. Aufl. 80p. 18>£cm. Stuttg., Marquardt & cie, 1939. HEISLER, Olga, 1911- ♦Hygiene der Jugendherbergen, nach Erhebungen im sudlichen Schwarzwald [Freiburg i. B.] 25p. 8? Schram- berg, Gasser & Hahn^ 1935. HEISLER, Wyldbore Helmut, 1908- *Vergleichende therapeutische Wirksamkeit eines gereinigten konzentrierten und eines nicht kon- zentrierten (nativen) Diphterieserums im Tier- versuch [Wurzburg] 7p. 8? Wertheim, E. Bechstein, 1935. HEISS, Elizabeth M[adeleine] 1908- A classification of the larvae and puparia of the Syrphidae of Illinois exclusive of aquatic forms. 142p. 8? Urbana, Univ. Illinois, 1938. Forms No. 4, v.16, Illinois Biol. Monogr. HEISS, Frohwalt, ♦Vermeidung von Sport- schaden am Bewegungsapparat [Habilitations- arbeit; Berlin] 56p. 23}4cm. Lpz., J. A. Barth, 1938. HEISS, Hubert, 1911- *Ueber Mund- spaltenverengerung unter besonderer Beriick- sichtigung eigener Beobachtungen. 30p. 8? Miinch., L. Schnitzler & co., 1935. HEISS, H[ugo] E[rnst] ♦Ueber die thera- peutische Beeinflussung der Avertinnarkose und ihrer Komplikationen. 9p. 21. 4? Munch., 1928. Tvpewritten. HEISS, Josef, 1908- ♦UeberdieSchmerz- empfindung und ihre Lokalisation in den harten Zahnsubstanzen. 36p. 8? Mtinch., Bayer. Dr. [1931] HEISS, Kurt, 1909- ♦Beitrag zur Wir- kung des Oxychinol Bengen auf den puerperal erkrankten Uterus des Rindes [Leipzig] 67p. 8? Vaihingen, A. Schnaufer, 1934. HEISS, Robert, 1884- Die prapara- torisch-anatomischen Metoden beim Menschen. p.683-901. 25cm. Berl., Urban & Schwarzen- berg, 1938. In Handb. biol. Arbeitsmeth. (Abderhalden, E.) Abt. 7, T. 2. HEISSMANN, Helene, 1909- ♦Musku- larer Haltungsverfall, Klimakterium und Arthro- pathia deformans [Freiburg] 16p. 22^cm. Wiirzb., R. Mayr, 1937. HEIST, George David, 1885-1920. Duke, C. W. Dr George D. Heist, hero of science, who fore- told his death, also a letter of transmittal of Solomon Solis- Cohen, Dec. 4, 1929. Pub. Ledger, Phila, Aug. 22, 1920. HEISTER, Henry, 1889- ♦Ueber den Versuch einer graphischen Darstellung des weissen Blutbildes in Form einer Wertigkeits- kurve [Frankfurt a. M.] 52p. 8? Wiesb., C. Ritter, 1930. HEISTER, Lorenz, 1683-1758. Programma de veritatis inveniendae difficultate in physica et medicina, quo lectorem benevolum ad orationem solennem, de hypothesium medicarum fallacia et pernicie ... invitat (4) 1. 19cm. Altdorf, Kohles [1710] No. 6, P. v. Altdorf theses pt 1. 227475—VOL. 7, 4th series----29 HEISTER ----Istituzioni chirurgiche; nelle quali si tratta con ottima e affatto nuova maniera chirurgica, e si rappresentano in molte tavole intagliate in rame li piu prestanti e necessarii stromenti, e parimenti gli artifiziosi modi, o siano le principali operazioni di mano e fasciature chirurgiche; opera di trent anni; quarto edizione Italiana, Tomo primo. xvi, 447p. illust. portr. 8? Venezia, F. Pitted, 1782. ---- & SCHUETTE, Johan Heinrich (resp.) ♦Dissertatio chirurgica de superfluis et noxiis quibusdam in chirurgia. 27p. 19cm. Altdorf, J. G. Kohles [1719] No. 7, P. v. Altdorf theses pt 1. See also Kruse, H. [W. P.] *Die Augenheilkunde bei Lorenz Heister [Jena] 66p. 8? Miinch, 1929. Also Heister's Surgery. Brit. M. J, Lond, 1913, 2: 80.— Vorwahl, H. Zum 250. Geburtstag des Chirurgen L. Heister. Deut. med. Wschr, 1933, 59: 1437. HEISTER, Paul, 1901- ♦Ueber Achylia gastrica. 92p. 8? Bonn, H. Trapp, 1929. HEITCHEN, Ernst Walter, 1907- ♦Spat- erf olge bei Meningozelenoperationen. 19p. 21cm. Weende, F. Pieper, 1935. HEITE, Hans Joachim, 1913- ♦Ver- gleichende Untersuchungen iiber die Wirkung einiger Capillargifte am Froschgefasspraparat, insonderheit dessen Adrenalinempfindlichkeit [Berlin] 23p. 22cm. Hamb., A. Preilipper, 1938. HEITGRESS, Hans Rudolf Heinrich Albert, 1910- ♦Scharlach nach Tonsillektomie [Freiburgi. B.] 19p. 8? Hamb., P. Evert, 1936. HEITGRESS, Wilhelm, 1907- ♦Beitrag zur Verbreitung und Bekampfung der Tricho- monadenseuche des Rindes. 31p. 8? Giessen, O. Kindt, 1935. HEITHOFF, Johannes, 1907- ♦Diagnose und Behandlung des kontrakten Plattfusses mit besonderer Beriicksichtigung der Vereisungs- methode des Nervus peronaeus [Miinster- 29p. 8? Neuenkirchen-Rheine, H. Lammers] dorf, 1931. HEITING, Hans, 1912- ♦Ueber die Hemmung der Milchsaurebildung in der Zelle durch Sauerstoff [Munchen] 14p. 23cm. Emsdetten, H. & J. Lechte, 1938. HEITMUELLER, Hugo, 1895- ♦Ein Beitrag zur Kasuistik und Statistik der Mund- hohlenerkrankungen unter besonderer Beruck- sichtigung der gutartigen Geschwulste. 43p. 8°. Gott., Handelsdr., 1928. HEITOR Deus, Antonio. ♦Algumas consi- deracoes sobre o tratamento das fracturas em V da extremidade inferior da tibia. 41p. 8! Lisb., J. G. de Sousa Neves, 1879. HEITSCH, Kurt. Untersuchungen iiber den Kaltgehalt der Milch unter besonderer Beriick- sichtigung des Einflusses der Fliitterung. 80p. tab. 8? Zeulenroda, B. Sporn, 1935. HEITSCH, Rolf, 1907- ♦Der Geruchs- sinn der Epileptiker. 30p. 21cm. Rostock, C. Hinstorff, 1936. HEITZ, Eva, 1905- ♦Eine Funktions- priifung des reticulo-endothelialen Systems bei Tuberkulosen. 39p. 8? Konigsb. i. Pr., E. Rautenberg, 1930. HEITZ, Jean, 1876- See Cade, Andr6, Santy, Paul, & Heitz, Jean. Tuberculose du tube digestif. 411p. 8? Par, 1937. HEITZMANN, Carl, 1836-96. Heitzmann, L. Recollections of my father. Urol. Cut. Rev, 1938, 42: 127. HEITZMANN, Louis, 1864- Urinary analysis and diagnosis by microscopical and chemical examination; 5. ed., with 131 illustra- HELD HEITZMANN 4, tions and a chapter on the determination of the functional efficiency of the kidneys, by Walter T. Dannreuther. 2 p. 1. xxi, 366p. 8? N. Y., W. Wood & co., 1928. Also 6. ed. xix, 385p. illust. sf Bait., W. Wood & co., 1934. HEIWLNKEL, Hermann, 1901- ♦Ueber das Papillom accessorischer Schilddriisen [Ber- lin] 51p. 8? Charlottenb., Gebr. Hoffmann, 1935. HEIZMANN, Olga, 1909- ♦Unmittel- bare und spate Folgeerscheinungen nach trau- matischen Hiiftgelenksverrenkungen. 37p. 8? Tiib., A. Becht, 1936. HEIZMANN, Rudolf, 1907- ♦Die Des- infektionsmittel bei Wunden und entziindlichen Erkrankungen in der Mundhohle unter besonderer Berucksichtigung des Chinosols [Freiburg i. B.] 20p. 8? Rendsburg, H. Moller Sonne [1931] HEJDA, Stanislav, 1877-1937. Jirasek, A. lObituary] Cas. lek. Cesk, 1937, 7G: 1651, portr. HEJINIAN, Aram Garahed, 1863-1934. Dolan, H. F. lObituary] J. Iowa M. Soc, 1934, 24: 543. HEKMAT, Abbas Gholi, 1911- +La sonorite angulaire pr6-hepatique; signe de pe>i- viscerite du carrefour superieur. 62p. 8? Par., E. Le Francois, 1938. HEKTOEN, Ludwig, 1863- Scarlet fever. 15p. 8? Topeka, Kans., 1930. Forms No. 2, v.8, Bull. Kansas Bd Health. ---- Scarlet fever prevalence, prevention suppression and control. 15p. 8? Topeka, 1935. Forms No. 1, v.13. Bull Kansas Bd Health. For biography see Arch. Path, Chic, 1938, 26: 3-18, portr. (M. Fishbcin) Also J. Am. M. Ass, 1941, 116: 1587. Also Sang, Par, 1927, 1: 162. portr. See also Bibliography of the writings of Ludvig Hektoen. Arch. Path, Chic, 1938, 26: 20-31.—(Ludvig Hektoen receives centennial award of the State Medical Society of Wisconsin] Wisconsin M. J, 1941, 40: 958, portr. HELBICH, Hans, 1879- Das Still- problem und Vorschlage zur Besserung der Stilltatigkeit. 41p. 8? Stuttg., F. Enke, 1939. Forms Beih. 19, Arch. Kinderh. HELBIG, Daniel Christoph, 1907- ♦Ueber einen Fall partieller Thrombose der Vena cen- tralis retinae, die durch Bestrahlung geheilt wurde. 13p. 8? Wiirzb. [n. pub.] 1934. HELBIG, Hugo, 1902- ♦Die Diagnose von Pankreaserkrankungen (aussere Drtisen- funktion) mittels Trypsinbestimmung im Duo- denalsaft und Nachweis von Headschen Zonen. 23p. 8? Halle, Schmidt & Erdel, 1929. HELBIG, Karl Heinz, 1913- *Die Lues bei Jugendlichen und Aelteren [Berlin] 19p. 8? Lengerich, Lengerich. Handelsdr., 1936. HELBIG, Wilhelm, 1914- ♦Unsere Wur- zelbehandlungs-Instrumente; ihre Gefahren und deren Verhiitung [Wurzburg] 40p. 8? Zeulen- roda, B. Sporn, 1937. HELBING, Elisabeth. ♦Beitrag zur Lehre von der Polyposis intestini und deren Beziehungen zum Carcinom. 21p. 8? [Erlangen, n. pub., 1930] HELBING, H. Modern materia medica for pharmacists, medical men, and students, vii, 202p. 8? N. Y., 1892. HELBING, Oskar, 1911- ♦Untersu- chungen iiber die Darmtatigkeit nach Bauch- operationen [Wurzburg] 19p. 8? Wertheim, E. Bechstein, 1936. HELBRANT, Maurice. Narcotic agent, viii, 319p. 21cm. N. Y., Vanguard Press [1941] HELD, Arthur Jean. ♦De quelques considera- tions sur les fractures des maxillaires et leurs complications. 29p. 8? Geneve, Impr. Chene & Terrassiere, 1929. ---- Les paradentoses et leur traitement (ancienne pyorrhee alveolaire ou maladie de Fauehard) 321p. illust. 25cm. Par., Masson & cie, 1939. HELD, Ernest R[odolphe] ♦Die peritoneale Wundbehandlung bei den doppelseitigen Adnexitis Operationen (einschliesslich Tamponade und Drainage) 42p. 8? Geneve, Impr. Commerce. 1929. HELD, Hanns, 1907- ♦Ueber das Prinzip einer neuen Methode zur Objektivierung der Palpation [Kiel] 23p. 8? Lpz., Frommhold & Wendler, 1935. HELD, Hans. ♦Contribution a l'etude de la resection apicale des dents anterieures premolaires et dents de six ans superieures et inf6rieures [Geneve] 72p. 8? Ziir., Imp. Berichthaus, 1936. HELD, Hans, 1866- Die Lehre von den Neuronen und vom Neurencytium und ihr heutiger Stand, p. 1. 44p. 8? Berl., Urban & Schwarzenberg, 1929. See also Stieve, H. Hans Held zu seinem siebzigsten Oc- burtstage am 8. August 1936. Zschr. mikr. anat. Forsch, 1936, 40: 1-28, portr. HELD, Hans Joachim, von, 1898- ♦Ue- ber das Aneurysma dissecans der Aorta und seine Pathogenese. 54p. 8? Bonn [n. pub.] 1932. HELD, Hans Lothar Heinrich, 1903- ♦Beitrag zur Frage der sogenannten essentiellen Hamaturie [Munster] 23p. 8? Oberhausen- Rhld., R. Kiihne, 1934. HELD, Isidore William, 1876- Biography. Rev. Gastroenter, 1936, 3: 345, portr. HELD, Joseph. See Landau. Anastase, & Held, Joseph. La syphilis gastri- que. 185p. 8? Par, 1936. HELD, Karl, 1910- ♦Die Lumineszenz- Analyse im filtrierten ultravioletten Licht und ihre Anwendung zur Fruhdiagnose der Karies. 26p. 8? Tiib., E. Gobel, 1934. HELD, Milly [geb. Haferkamp] 1908- ♦Geburtskomplikationen bei Nabelschnuranoma- lien [Munster] 16p. 22cm. Diisseld., G. H. Nolte, 1936. HELD, Siegfried, 1910- ♦Unklare Todes- falle und Banginfektionen. 35p. 8? Lpz., A. Edelmann, 1935. HELD, Wilhelm. Die Urinschau des Mittel- alters und die Harnuntersuchung der Gegenwart. 150p. 8? Lpz., Kriiger & co., 1931. HELDRICH, Hans Eberhard, 1909- ♦Knochensarkom in ursachlichem Zusammen- hang mit Trauma [Munchen] 42p. 8? Berl., R. Pfau [1937] HELDT, Fritz, 1905- ♦Dosierungsfrage des Diphtherie-Serums auf Grund der Schleim- haut diphtherie des Meerschweinchens [Wurz- burg] 12p. 8? Kallmiinz, M. Lassleben, 1936. HELDT, Hans, 1904- ^Die operativen Erfolge bei Hydrophthalmus an der Universitats- augenklinik Wurzburg von 1925-28 [Wurzburg] 16p. 8? Charlottenb., Gebr. Hoffmann, 1930. HELDT, Hans, 1906- ♦Der Einfluss der Intracervikalbehandlung der Gonorrhoe beim Weibe auf klinischen Verlauf und Heilungsdauer. 30p. 8? Munch., Hoffmann [1931] HELDT, Heinz, 1906- ♦Ueber Gefass- unterbindungsinstrumente und ein neues Instru- ment zur Vereinfachung doppelter Unterbindun- gen. 14p. pl. 8? Berl., Michel, 1933. HELDWEIN, Johannes. Die Geschichte der Feuerbestattung und deutsche Krematorien. 45, 2p. illust. 40 pl. 8? Frankf., Franzmathes, HELENIUM 451 HELICIDAE HELENIUM [arid derivatives] See also Compositae. Balyeat, R. M, Rinkel, H. J, & Stemen, T. R. Contact dermatitis (venenata) distribution and importance of the heleniums as a cause of contact dermatitis in the United States, Am. J. M. Sc, 1932, 184: 547.—Delore, P., & Coudert. Etude de Taction de l'hfM6nine sur le taux et l'expectoration. Lyon m6d„ 1938, 161:450-5. HELF, Theodor, 1895- ♦TJrobilinogen- nachweis im Ham (Ehrlichsche Aldehydreaktion) als Hilfsmittel bei Erkennung von Hirnblutleiter- erkrankungen im Verlauf eitriger Mittelohrent- zundung. 20p. 8? Miinch. [n. pub.] 1926. HELFAND, Max, 1897- See Marburg, O, & Helfand, M. Injuries of the nervous system, including poisonings. 2i3p. 22cm. N. Y, 1939. HELFERICH, Heinrich, 1851- Enderlen [Biographyl Chirurg, 1931, 3: 289-91. For Festschrift see Deut. Zschr. Chir, 1931, 232: portr. HELFERICH, Ludwig, 1907- ♦Bericht iiber die in den Jahren 1925-32 behandelten Falle von Cataracta traumatica an der Universi- tatsaugenklinik Wurzburg [Wurzburg] 21p. 8? Schweinfurt, Morich, 1937. HELFRECHT, Josef, 1908- ♦Umfang, Wesen und Begriff der Degenerationszeichen. 52p. 20>'2cm. Erlangen, K. Dores, 1937. HELFRICH, Edward Daniel, 1875-1930. Obituary. Tr. Am Acad. Ophth. Otolar, 1939, p. 415. HELGERT, Wilhelm, 1912- ♦Vorbeu- gende Zahnheilkunde und ihre Auswirkung fiir die Jungzahnarzteschaft. 31p. 8? Miinch., Hohenhaus, 1937. HELIANTHACEAE. See also Carduaceae. Callegari, L. Contenuto in vitamina Bi e propriety anti- neuritiche; ricerche sui semi di girasole. Boll. Soc. ital. biol. sper, 1939, 14: 484—6.—Danzel, L. A propos de l'h^Iianthe ou grand soleil plante industrielle et m^dicinale. Rev. m<5d. hyg. trop. Par, 1929, 21: 158-63.—Dechambre, P. Emploi du topinambour dans l'alimentation des animaux. Rec. mid. vit., 1918, 94: 119-22.—Leclerc, H. Les 16gumes.de topinambour (HSlianthus tuberoeus L.) Presse m/-d„ 1926, 39: 93 — Macarovici. C. G. Die Autooxydation des Sonnenblumenoles und die Taufel-Sadlersehe Reaktion. Bull. Acad, roumain, 1939-40, 22: 496-513.— Utilidades do girasol. Impr. med, Rio, 1941, 17: No. 326, 155.—Zechmeister, L, & Tuzson, P. Ueber eine sterinartige Verbindung aus den Kelchblattern der Sonnenblume. Zschr. physiol. Chem, 1930, 192: 22-4. HELIANTHIN. See Methyl orange. HELIARD, Henri Alexandre Alphonse, 1908- ♦Les papillomes des bovides [Alfort] 75p. 8? Par., Vigot freres, 1934. HELICHRYSIUM. See also Inulaceae. Petrowsky, G. Zur Pharmakologie der gallentreibenden Wirkung des Helichrysium arenarium (Katzenpf6tchen) Arch. internat. pharm. dyn. Par, 1937, 57: 99-109. HELICIDAE. See also Gastropoda; Molluscs. Ancel, P. Sur les premieres phases du d^veloppement de la glande g^nitale et du canal hermaphrodite chez Helix pomatia. Bibliogr. anat. Par, 1902. 10: 160-2. Histogenese et structure de la glande hermaphrodite d'Helix pomatia (Linn) Arch, biol. Par, 1902-3, 19: 389-652, 7 pl — Baburina, E. A. [The muscular cells of the foot of Helix po- matia] Arch. russ. anat, 1939, 21: ser. B, 75-102, 3 pl.— Bachrach, E, & Cardot. H. Contractilite et excitabihte du flagelle de l'escargot. C. rend. Soc. biol, 1921, 85: 170-2 — Bellion, M. Diminution des sucres chez l'escargot (Helix pomatia L.) pendant la pdriode d'activit^. Ibid, 1907, 63: 238-40. ------ I^s corps r^ducteurs chez l'escargot (Helix pomatia L.) Ibid, 1909, 66: 878-80. ------ Les echanges respiratoires chez l'escargot (Helix pomatia L.) Ibid, 917.— Bochenek, A. L'anatomie fine de la cellule nerveuse de Helix pomatia Lin. C. rend. Ass. anat, Nancy, 1901, 3: 106-10. ------ Contribution k l'etude du systeme nerveux des gas- tdropodes (Helix pomatia Lin.) anatomie fine des cellules nerveuses. Nevraxe, Louvain, 1901, 3: 83-105. 2 pl.—Cardot, H., & Troussier, E. Evaluation de la quantite totale d'hemo- ter° °™Z l|scargot C. rend. Soc. biol, 1930, 103: 71-3.- fWnJw^w rUr a s^.^tlorLde la glande albuminipare chez 1 escargot (Hehx pomatia et Helix hortensis) Ibid, 1902 54- 8>0-2.—Courtois, A, Duval, M. Sur la mort des escarad. Mitt. Biochem, 1934, 41: 99-101.—Mariclte, E. S. V summary of the indications, technic and results to be ex- pected in the use of both artificial and natural heliotherapy. Minnesota M, 1931, 14: 793-808.—Moncorvo, filho. A cura pelo sol. Sciencia med, Rio, 1924, 2: 280-92.—Nadig, N. R. Heliotherapy or sun cure. Ind. M. Gaz, 1936, 71, 6: 342.— Nelson, M. O. Observations bearing on the use of ultra-violet rays and sunlight. J. Oklahoma M. Ass, 1935, 28: 212-7 — Pathault. Air et lumidre: compendium des connaissancea indispensables k l'usage des bains d'air et de lumigre; aeration et insolation hygiiSniques. Marseille mid., 1934, 71: 157; passim. ------ L'heiiotherapie vue par un praticien. Avenir mid., Par, 1939, 36: 49; 80.—Pauchet, V. Le medecin doit faire campagne pour les bains de soleil. Clinique, Par, 1927, 22: 341.—Petitpierre, M. De quelques considerations pratiques en heliotherapie. Fundam. radiol, Berl, 1939, 4: 55-8.— Sardou, G. Heliophilie, heliophobie. In Traite helio & actin. (Brody, C.) Par, 1938, 1: 751-60. ---- artificial. See Ultraviolet ray. ---- Biochemical effect. Rodenwald, K. H. [H. H. F. G.] ♦Ueber das Verhalten des Blutzuckerspiegels bei Sonnen- badern am Strand [Rostock] 19p. 21cm. Sternberg, 1934. Schultz, E. [H. H.] +Ueber den Einfluss der Sonnenstrahlung auf den respiratorischen Stoff- wechsel. 24p. 8? Rostock, 1935. Aimes, A, & Cayla, J. Action de l'heiiotherapie sur l'acti- vite pho-phatique du serum. Bull. Acad, med. Par, 1935, 3. ser, 114: 357-61. Also Presse therm, clim, 1935, 76: 539; 777.------ Variations parall£les de la phosphat&nie et de la calcemie au cours de l'heiiotherapie. Bull. Acad. m<5d. Par, 1935, 3. ser, 114: 327-9. Also Presse therm, clim, 1935, 76: 776. ------ Natrtovie et reserve alealine du serum au cours de 1 heliotherapie. Bull. Acad, med. Par, 1936, 3. eer, 115: 672-5.—Brussilowski, E. M, & Lurje, H. Ueber den Einfluss der Sonnenbader auf die Veriinderung des Blutgasge- halts bei Kranken. Zschr. ges. phys. Ther, 1926-27, 32: 203-6— Deschwanden, J. von. Die Einwirkung der natilr- hchen Hohensonne auf die Blutzuckerkurve. Schweiz. med. Wschr, 1929, 59: 903-6.—Egidi, E., & Rowinski, P. Bagno di sole e glicerofosfati del siero. Boll. Soc. ital. biol. sper, 1934, 9: 118.—Gelonesi, G. Bagni di sole e modificazioni che ne seguono per l'uomo sul potere delle urine ad attivare o rneno la fermentazione alcoolica delle soluzioni di glucosio. Ann. med. nav, Roma, 1934, 40: 257-76.—Malczynski, St. [the curve of cholesterin in the blood of animals after irradia- tion with sun rays] Polska gaz. lek, 1934, 13: 636.— Messerle, N. Das Verhalten des Blutzuckers und der Adrena- linquaddel nach Quarzlampenbestrahlung und nach Sonnen- badern. Schweiz. med. Wschr., 1927, 57: 759-61.—Morganti, HELIOTHERAPY 453 HELIOTHERAPY F Modificazioni della riserva alcalina in rapporto all'elio- terapia. Pediatria (Riv.) 1936, 44: 505^-20— Risak, E. Ueber das Auftreten von Melaninreaktionen im menschlichen Harne nach Sonnenbestrahlung. Wien. klin. Wschr, 1930, 43: 358-61. ------ & Asperger, H. Neue Untersuchungen uber das Auftreten von Melaninreaktionen im menschlichen Harn nach Sonnenbestrahlung. Klin. Wschr, 1932, 11: 154-6.— Risler, J, & Foveau de Courmelles. Action du soleil sur le potassium de l'organisme vivant. Arch, electr. med, 1926, 36: p. cxcix-cciii.—Saidman, J. De Taction hypercalcifianti du traitement solaire concentre. Ann. Inst, actin. Par, 1935- 36, 10: 111-9, 17 pl.—Schaaf, F., & Mu, J. W. Auftreten von Melanogen im Urin nach Sonnenbestrahlung. Klin. Wschr, 1931, 10: 1722.—Tisdall, F. F, & Price, H. W. The effect ol sunshine on the acidity of the intestinal tract of rachitic rats Bull. Johns Hopkins Hosp, 1927, 41: 432-6.—Wechsler, M. I. [Changes in the urine in healthy subjects from the effect ol sun-baths] Tr. Gosud. nauch. inst. fizioter. Semashko, 1934, 2: 42-6. ---- Biological effect. See also under Light; Sunlight. Destreicher, M. ♦Role et utilisation du soleil comme agent sterilisant. 112p. 8? Par., 1937. Aimes, A. Les effets de la cure solaire sur l'organisme. Kongrber. Interhat. Kongr. Lichtforsch, 1936, 3. Congr, 132-5. ------ & Cayala, J. La pigmentation dans la cure solaire. Gaz. med. France, 1936, 43: 509-17. ------■ Pre- miere serie d'experiences sur les effets physiologiques de la cure heiio-marine. Rev. orthop. Par, 1937, 24: 150-65.— Barboni, U. L'emogramma di Schilling nella cura elioterapica. Athena, Roma, 1934, 3: 112-9.—Belusov, V, & Livshina, M. [Action of sun-baths on blood pressure, pulse and respiration of children] Vrach. gaz, 1927, 31: 846-9.—Brody, C. Modifica- tion k apporter k l'ancienne technique heiiotherapique ne favorisant paa la pigmentation solaire. Bull. Acad, med. Par, 1933, 3. ser, 110: 111-7. Also Presse therm, clim, 1933, 74: 605.—Cauvin, J. F. Des bienfaits de l'insolation. Stras- bourg med, 1933, 93: 763-7.—Chubinsky, S. M. [On the threshold sensitiveness of the skin in heliotherapy] Fizio- terapia, Moskva, 1941, No. 2, 29-34.—Colebrook, L. The influence of sunlight upon the bactericidal power of human blood. Brit. M. J, 1924, 2: 11.—Costa, A. Modificazioni della reazione della cute a taluni stimoli in seguito all'irradia- zione solare in alta montagna. Arch. sc. med. Tor, 1939, 68: 281-304.—Di Macco, G. Variazioni locali della pressione arteriosa per azione dei raggi solari. Boll. Soc. ital. biol. sper, 1932, 7: 954. Also Riv. pat. sper, 1932, 8: 211-22.—Downes, A. The discovery of the antiseptic power of sunlight recorded after 55 years. Chem. News, Lond, 1932, 145: 65.—Egorov, A. [The effect of sun baths on the thermo-resistance and fluctuation of erythrocytes] Russ. klin, 1928, 10: 12-8.—Epstein, S. Einfluss der Sonne auf den Organismus. Deut. Aerzte Ztg, 1932, 7: No. 315.—Feldmann, L, & Azuma, Y. Ueber die vasoconstrictorische Kraft des Blutes nach Sonnenbestrahlung. Zschr. ges. exp. Med, 1928, 62: 259-63.— Gauvain, H. The effect of heliotherapy and artificial light treatment on the mentality of patients. Mat. Child Welf, Lond, 1925, 9: 217-20.—Geyer, M. Influenza della luce solare sulla pressione arteriosa dell'uomo. Riv. radiol, 1931, 3: 156-67.—-Goodman, H. Sunburn tanning; comment on the action of light on the 3kin. Arch. Derm. Syph, Chic, 1932, 25: 15-20.—Gu6rin, R, Donnadieu, A, & Gourdon. Helio- therapie et pigmentation. Bordeaux chir, 1933, 4: 401.— Halluin, M. d\ Proprietes biologiques du rayonnement so- laire. In Traite helio & actin. (Brody, C.) Par, 1938, 1: 633-75.—Hoeffel, G., & Lyons, D. Heliotherapy and the peripheral blood. Am. J. Dis. Child, 1930-31, 40: 484-92 — Huchman, A. M. [Capillaroscopy in heliotherapy] Radianska med, 1937, 2: No. 12, 27-9.—Ianfts, A., Chiser, S., & Teodoru, P. [Modification of the blood in consecutive exposures to the sun] Rev. st. med, Bucur, 1931, 20: 468-85. ■ [Effect of heliotherapy on the parasympathetic system] Ibid, 1369- 72.—Ianfts, A., Opreanu, N, & Criveanu, C. [Certain modi- fications of the blood from heliotherapy on seashore] Ibid, 1930, 19: 409-11, 8 ch.—Juster, E. Quelques formules de produits pour brunir. Presse med, 1934, 42: 1331.—Kartscha- gin, W, & Joffe, G. Ueber den Einfluss des Pigments auf die Grosse des photoelektrischen Effektes der Haut bei Sonnen- badern. Zschr. ges. phys. Ther, 1929, 37: 19-27.—Kashkin- baev, I. T. [Thermoregulation of the body in sun-baths.] Tr. Gosud. nauch. inst. fizioter. Semashko, 1934, 2: 52-8.— Kauczyfiski, K. [Epicritic sensibility of the skin to the sun rays] Polska gaz. lek, 1928, 7: 196-9—KestnerO. Blut und Sonnenstrahlung. Fortsch. Ther, 1925. 1: 390-2.------ Johnson, C. E, & Laubmann, W. Stoffwechsel und Sonnen- strahlung. Strahlentherapie, 1931, 41: 174—Lapteya-Popova, M. S. [Changes of the red blood cells during heliotherapy] Omsky med. J, 1929, 4: 37-45.—Lcpeschkin, W. W. Ueber den Einfluss des Sonnenlichts auf die ™ten Blutkorperchen des Menschen in vivo. Strahlentherapie, 1934, 51: 330-48 — Levine, V. E. Sunlight, nutrition and metabolism; hemo- globin production, erythrocyte formation and reticulocyte response. Arch. Phys. Ther, 1931, 12: 389-400.—Liverani, E. La formula di Arneth nell'elio- ed attinoterapia. Actinoterapia, Nap 1928 7: 165-78.—Magliozzi, G. Variazioni della pressione sanguigna negli arti esposti ai raggi solari. Bull. ^oc. ital. biol. sper, 1932, 7: 952. Also Rass. ter. oat. clin, 1932, 4: 279-88—Mann, D. Beware of lifeguard tan. Phys. Cull, N. Y, 1941, 86: No. 2, 34.—Martinez de la Cruz, F. La influencia de los rayos solares en el organismo. Bol. Col. med. Camaguey, 1939. 1: 39-45.—Meader, F. M. Sunlight as a disinfectant. J. Michigan M. Soc, 1926, 25: 636-45 — Mercogliano, P. Effetti dei raggi solari sul sistema nervoso con particolare riguardo alle meningi. Rinasc. med, 1930, 7: 549-51.—Morganti, F. La prova di Aldrich e McClure nell'infanzia e l'elioterapia. Riv. clin. pediat, 1936, 34: 34-55.—Nishida, T. Hygienische Studien iiber die Wirkung des Sonnenlichtes. Fukuoka acta med, 1929, 22: 43.— Nogami, Y. Ueber die chemische Messung und das bakterizide Vermogen der Ultraviolettstrahlen, der kunstlichen Hohen- sonnenlampe und der Sonnenstrahlen in Japan. Kitasato Arch, 1933, 10: 135-63.—Porcellati, G. Variazioni ematiche regionali da irradiazione solare. Boll. Soc. ital. biol. sper, 1932, 7: 950.—Pudor, H. Sonnenbiologie und Lebensklima- lehre. Naturarztl. Rdsch, 1935, 7: 82-7.—Ramond, L. Un brunissement exagere. Presse med, 1939, 47: 1405.— Rollier, A., & Leuba, W. Le role de la peau dans la cure heiio- climatique. Clinique, Par, 1940, 35: 51-3.—Ross, J. R, Robertson, E. C, & Tisdall, F. F. Effect of sunshine through window glass and fresh air on resistance to infection; experi- ments on animals. Am. J. Dis. Child, 1933, 45: 81-95. Also repr.—Scagliosi, G. Azione del sole e dei raggi ultravioletti sull'organismo sano e malato. Pensiero med, 1927, 16: 746-66.—Sheard, C, & Higgins, G. M. The effects of selective solar radiations on growth and development. Proc. Mayo Clin, 1928, 3: 75.—Sirotinin, G. [Action of sun-baths on morphologic elements of the blood] Klin, med, Moskva, 1927, 5: 1214-8.—Troitskaia, O. I. [Effect of sun-baths on the nervous system] In Kurort, lech, uslov. sever, klim. (Zavadsky, N. A.) Leningr, 1935, 65-78.—Vallot, J. L'heiiotherapie et l'activite de la reduction des tissus animaux. Rev. path. comp. Par, 1922, 22: 37-41.—Vardina, C. Ricerche compara- tive sul potere battericida del sangue al piano ed in alta mon- tagna: azione della fatica e delle irradiazioni solari. Gior. batt. immun, 1927, 2: 101-10.—Weksler, M. I. [Effect of sun-baths on blood pressure] Tr. Gosud. nauch. inst. fizioter. Semashko, 1934, 2: 47-51.—Woringer, P. Die Wirkung des Sonnenlichtes auf die immunisatorische Funktion der Haut. Strahlentherapie, 1930-31, 39: 493-9. ---- Congresses. Jan si on, H. Reunion de la Societe francaise d'heliotherapie et de photobiologie, HySres, Giens 19 et 20 fevrier 1939. Fundam. radiol, Berl, 1939, 5: 153-6.—Krainik, R. Les journees d'heliotherapie d'Hy^res. Ann. Inst, actin. Par, 1938-39, 13: 49-52.—M., J. Premiere seance de la Societe francaise d'heliotherapie et de photobiologie. Rev. physio- ther. Par, 1938, 14: 36. ---- Dosage. See also Heliometry. Evans, I. O. Sensible sun-bathing. 47p. 12? Lond. [1935] Beliakov, S. V. [Sedimentation reaction as a method of dosage of sun-baths] Tr. Gosud. nauch. inst. fizioter. Semashko, 1934, 2: 59-67.—Boiko, A. N. [Dosage of sun-baths in refer- ence to ultra-violet radiation] In Kurort, lech, uslov. sever. klim. (Zavadsky, N. A.) Leningr, 1935, 53-64.—Borsarelli, F. Ricerche sulla durata utile dell'elioterapia. Pediat. med. prat. Tor, 1935, 10: 78-84.—Earp, J. R. Dosage in helio- therapy; a plea for laboratory control. J. Am. M. Ass, 1929, 92: 312.—Grober, J. The importance of correct dosage in heliotherapy. S. Afr. M. J, 1939, 13: 795-8—Mezernitzky, P. I. Une nouvelle methode de dosimetrie des bains soleil. C. rend. Acad, sc, 1927, 185: 1169.—Morikofer, W. Anregun- gen zur Frage der Dosierung bei Sonnenbestrahlungskuren. Strahlentherapie, 1931, 40: 682-9.—Palchinsky, V. S. [Albe- dometry in practical heliotherapy] Vopr. kurort, 1941, No. 2, 53.—Riemerschmid, G. Messungen der Strahlung und der Abkuhlung als Dosierungsgrundlage in der Heliotherapie; dargestellt an einem Beispiel von Untersuchungen in Kenya, Ostafrika. Strahlentherapie, 1937, 59: 690-710.—Roussel, P. Das Dosierungsproblem bei der Heliotherapie der inneren Organe. Ibid, 1930-31, 39: 787-93.—Saidman, J. Le choix des doses en actinotherapie et en heliotherapie. Rev. actin. Par, 1928, 4: 148-63.—Tregubov, S. L. Ueber die Dosierung bei der Heliotherapie. Acta chir. scand, 1930, 67: 892-905. Also Arch. fr. belg. chir, 1933, 34: 185-9. Also Bordeaux chir, 1933, 4: 400. ---- Health resorts, and institutes. See also Climatotherapy. Faure, M. L'heiiotherapie sur le Littoral Mediterranean Frangais. 71p. 8? Par., 1919. Rabine, S. ♦L'heiiotherapie a la montagne et dans le sanatorium. 53p. 8? Par., 1931. Sanson, E. ♦La cure helio-marine au Solarium Lerch du Havre. 40p. 24cm. Par., 1939. HELIOTHERAPY 454 HELIOTHERAPY Amende, H. Exposition, photochemische Ortshelligkeit, Heliotherapie und Platzwahl von Krankenanstalten. Strahlen- therapie, 1938, 63: 115-28 -Armand-Delille, P. F. Les resultats de la cure heiiotherapique au sanatorium d'Odeillo. Bull. Acad, med. Par, 1927, 3. ser, 97: 801-3. ------ L'heiiotherapie en altitude dans les stations de montagne francaises. Gaz. med. France, 1931, 450-2.—Baidikov, I. [Value of meteorologic factors of heliotherapy in Tashkent] Med. misl, Tashkent, 1930-31, 5: 37-48.—Barraud, G. La cure solaire k la mer. Hopital, 1927, 15: 293-7.—Berard, F. La cure heiiomarine en Mediterranee. Sem. hop. Paris, 1932, 8: 49. ------ L'heiiotherapie en Mediterranee. Kongrber. Internat. Kongr. Lichtforsch, 1936, 3. Congr, 378-86, 4 pl.— Itianrani, E, & Biancani, H. La sante des enfants des ecoles de Paris et le role prophylactique et therapeutique des centres d'hygiene infantile du raynn de soleil. J. med. Paris, 1936, 56: 435.—Borsarelli, F. Intorno al funzionamento di una colonia elioterapica. Pediat. med. prat. Tor, 1934, 9: 136- 40.—Bushnell, F. G. Public sun and air baths. J. R. San. Inst, 1928-29, 49: 449-55.—Cabras, F. Un istituto ortopedico- elioterapico al Lido di Venezia, il solarium al mare. Arch. ital. chir, 1938, 48: 891.—Calve, J, & Froyez. R. L'heiio- therapie k la mer. Gaz. med. France, 1931, 452-4.—Carleton, S. H. Sunshine camp; a preventive measure which any com- munity might achieve. Trained Nurse, 1938, 101: 132-5.— Casalini, G. Un colonia elioterapica modello. Igiene & vita, 1937, 20: 9-11.—Ceresole, G. L'heiiotherapie au bord de la mer. Rapp. Conf. internat. lumiere (1928) 1929, 1. Conf, 384-7.—Daley, W. A. How far sunlight treatment should be part of the work of a public health department. J. R. San. Inst, 1928-29, 49: 443-8.—Danilova, V. D. [Hours for sun- baths in the treatment at the pioneer camp at the northern shore of the Azov sea] Pediatria, Moskva, 1940, No. 9, 80-4.— Delaria, A. Sull'iiiizio, sulla durata e sulla tecnica delle colonie elioterapiche. Pediatria (Riv.) 1935, 43: 723-8.—Dumrese, J. Sonnenbehandlung im Krankenhaus. Hippokrates, Stuttg, 1937, 8: 866-70.—Ferrando, G. Un sguardo sulla Colonia Elioterapica permanente 3 gennaio di Torino. Gazz. osp, 1937, 58: 529-31. ------ Datos ilustrativos de tecnico- asistencia sobre la colonia helioter&pica permanente 3 de enero. Dia med, B. Air,' 1938, 10: 1122-4.—Frontali. G. Cure actiniche al mare. Clin, igiene inf., 1932, 7: 213-28. —Gaudier, H. La clinique-manufacture k Leysin (Suisse) Echo med. nord, 1932, 36: 313-7.—Gauvain, H. Sun treatment in Eng- land. Clin. J, Lond, 1930, 59: 361-5.—Guglielmini, T. La Colonia elioterapica milanese di via Polesine nei suo primo anno di vita. Pediat. prat. Mod, 1934, 11:375-84.------II funzionamento ed i risultati della colonia elioterapica com- munale di Baggio nell'estate 1935. Ibid, 1935. 12: 303-70 — Hausmann, \V. Grundlagen und Organisation der lichtklima- tischen Forschung in ihrer Beziehung zur offentlichen Gesund- heitspflcge. Mitt. Volksgesundhamt, Wien, 1932, 78 — Jaubert, J. Hy^res et sa region, centre de la cure heiio-marine. Rev. physiother. Par, 1938, 14: 201.— Jaubert, L. Organisa- tion et materiel des cliniques d'heliotherapie. Ann. Inst. actin. Par, 1932-33, 6: 34-41.—Josephson, O. J. La methode de solarium tournant. Ibid, 1933-34, 8: 1-32, 8 pl.—Kotzde, W. Ein Tag im Sonnenland. Aerztl. Mitt, Lpz, 1928, 29: [Horrohr] 17-9.—Kufferath, A. Die Bedeutung der Schullicht- institute fur die heranwachsende Jugend. Techn. Gemeindebl, 1934, 37: 64-6.—Ledent, R, & Dubois-Trepagne. L'heiio- therapie et l'actinotherapie en Belgique. Rapp. Conf. internat. lumiere (1928) 1929, 1. Conf, 481-507.—Mackenzie, D. W. M, & Smith. A. F. Experiment with a sunlight clinic. J. R. Army M. Corps, 1940, 74: 99.—Maggia, O. Rilievi sull'elio- terapia nelle colonie diurne estive del P. N. F. di Ivrea nell'anno XIII. Pediat. med. prat, 1936, 11: 560-71.—Mehta, P. M. A solarium for heliotherapy. Practitioner. Lond, 1935, 135: 237-9. ------ La radiation solaire au solarium de Jamnagar. Ann. Inst, actin. Par, 1935-36, 10: 104-7.—Methling, H. Liegekuren auf Norderney und die neue Liegehalle der Kinder- heilstatte Seehospiz Kaiserin-Friedrich. Zschr. wiss. Baderk, 1927-28, 2: 146-50.—Meyer, E. G. Sonnenbader in der Mark Brandenburg. Strahlentherapie, 1934, 51: 355 8.—Monteiro, J. Os banhos de sol: sua accSo medico-social. Rev. brasil. med, 1928, 4: 357-83.—Morton, F. Das Lichtklima von Hallstatt im oberosterreichischen Salzkammergut. Strahlen- therapie, 1930-31, 39: 38.5-90.—Nilson, E. A. [On helio- therapy in the city of Tashkent] Tr. Gosud. nauch. inst. fizioter. Semashko, 1934, 2: 31-41.—Obukhov, B. V, & Mize- rova, M. B. [Heliotherapy during the winter months at the health resort Sochi-Matsesta] Vopr. kurort, 1941, No. 2, 41-4.—Peliu, M, & Imbert, P. Les abus de l'heiiotherapie en Mediterranee. Presse therm, clim, 1934, 75: 269-73.— Rollier, A. Heliotherapy and child welfare. Child, Lond, 1926-27, 17: 129-33. — Die Heliotherapie im Hochge- birge. Strahlentherapie, 1928, 28: 259-81. ------ Helio- therapy at Leysin. Am. Med, 1932, 38: 77-80.—Saidman, J. Description du sanatorium heiiotherapique de l'lnstitut d'Actinologie. Ann. Inst, actin. Par, 1934-35, 9: 57-67, 4 pl.—Satta, F. Primi risultati della cura elioterapica negli istituti di Pietraligure. Illust. med. ital, 1926, 8: 157-64.— Silberbauer, S. F. Heliotherapy; some impressions derived in Switzerland. S. Afr. M. Rec, 1925, 23: 557-9.— Simionato, A. G. Nota sulla colonia elioterapica di Grigno. Boll med trent, 1934, 49: 159-66.—Vacchelli, S. Un decennio di osservazioni meteorologiche nell'Instituto Elioterapico Codi- villa Cortina d'Ampezzo, 1924-33. Riv. idroclim, 1935, 46: 339-61.—Wasilewska-Lobzowa. H. [On heliotherapy and curative exercises in the Institute of Dr E. Lewickn in Druskic- niki] Polska gaz. lek, 1938, 17: 456-8- Winrkler, A. 1st die Einrichtung von Sonnenbiidern fiir detilsche Kurorte zweckmassig? Fortsch. Med, 1925, 43: 344-6. ---- History. Bakhati, M. K. +Die Licht- und Sonnenbe- handlung im Heilschatz der alien Mittel meer- volker. 24p. 8? Wurzb., 1937. Ott, R. ♦Die Heliotherapie in ihrer geschicht- lichen Entwicklung [Munchen] 32p. 8? Kall- miinz, 1935. Weber, E. +Das Sonnenlieht als thcra- peutischer Faktor; Entwicklung und gegen- wartiger Stand der Heliotherapie [Munchen] 39p. 21cm. Kallmiinz, 1937. Armand-Delille, P. F. L'heiiotherapie. Progr. med. Par, 1928,43:881-91. ----— Le developpement de l'heiiotherapie en France. Rapp. Conf. internat. lumiere (1928) 1929, 1. Conf, 522-6.—Bernhard, O. Die Entwicklung der Klima- und Heliotherapie im Hochgebirge. Zschr. wiss. Baderk, 1930-31, 5: 22-9. ------ L'evolution historique du traite- ment solaire. In Traite helio & actin. (Brody, C.) Par, 1938, 1:5-19.—Brown, R. K. Light treatment an historical review. Brit. J. Phys. M, 1934, 8: 169-72.—Cawadias, A. P. Helio- therapy and actinotherapy; past, present and future. Ibid, 1935-36, 10: 211-4.—Cipriani, M. La fototerapia naturale e artificiale attraverso i tempi. Raggi ultraviol, 1932, 8: 65.— Duhot, E. L'histoire de l'heiiotherapie. Echo med. nord, 1932, 36: 87-91.—Furniss, A. Sun treatment down the ages. Med. Press & Circ, Lond, 1936, 192: 31-3.—de Kruif, P. Rollier y las maravillosas curas de sol. Rev. med, Puebla, 1937, 10: No. 86, 8-10.—Pathault. Le Professeur Antonin Poncet createur de l'heiiotherapie moderne. Gaz. med. France, 1939, 46: 55.—Reed, C. I. Old sun-worship finds vindication in modern laboratory. Nation's Health, Chic, 1926, 8: 535.—Romagucra, L. P. Historia de la helioterapia en Cuba. Rev. med. cir. Habana, 1937, 42: 277-84.—Saidman, J. Quelques progr^s dans l'emploi du medicament soleil. Bull. Soc. med. Paris, 1938, 362-7. Also Med. Rec, N. Y, 1939, 150: 438.—Santamarina, V. Datos hist6ricos sobre helioterapia. Rev. med. cir. Habana, 1937, 42: 16-34.— Webb, G. B. Heliology and heliosis. J. Outdoor Life, 1927, 24: 399. ---- Indication. See also under names of diseases and medical specialties as Dermatology, Therapeutics; Tuber- culosis, Treatment, &c. Rollier, A. Heliotherapy with special con- sideration of surgical tuberculosis. Transl. by G. de Swietochowski [2. ed.] 318p. 8? Lond. [1927] Ambrus, J. [Sunbath and hemoptysis] Orv. hetil, 1935, 79: mell, 21.—Andre, J. Heliotherapie ou actinotln'rapie. Bruxelles med, 1926-27, 7: 1283-92.—Ballico, I. I.'elio- terapia e la fototerapia con speciale riguardo alle malattie celtiche e delle pelle. Raggi ultraviol, 1926, 2: 274; 1927, 3: 35; 158.—Bernhard. O. Die Sonnenlichtbehandlung in der Chirurgie; die Heliotherapie nichttuberkuloser chirurgischer Leiden. Med. Welt, 1934, 8: 221-4.—Brody, C. Les indica- tions principales de la cure solaire naturelle et artificielle. In Traite helio & actin. (Brody, C.) Par, 1938, 1: 763-70 — Conclusions des travaux sur les indications et les contre- indications des bains de soleil. Presse therm, clim, 1935, 76: 659.—Dorcas, M. J. Sunshine for therapeutic use. Med. J. & Rec, 1930, 132: 605.—Forster, A. M. Heliotherapy. Tr. Nat. Tuberc. Ass, N. Y, 1928, 24: 136-40, 4 pl.—Gauvain, H. The use and abuse of heliotherapy. Med. Press & Circ, Lond, 1939, 202: Suppl, p. i-iii.—Grasso, H. L. Sun baths: use and abuses. J. Am. Ass. Promot. Hyg, 1929, 12: 47-51 — Gross, R. H. Physiotherapy in podiatry; heliotherapy. J. Nat. Ass. Chiropod, 1934, 24: No. 5, 17.—Heckel, F. Tech- nique des bains de soleil dans le but de modifier la nutrition des tuberculeux, des obeses, des diabetiques, des cellulitiques, des rhumatisants et des arthritiques. Arch. Inst, prophyl. Par, 1934, 6: 233-53.—Heuer, G. J. Heliotherapy as an adjunct in the treatment of chronic surgical conditions. Proc. Interst. Postgrad. M. Ass. N. America, 1925, 1: 169-76. Also Med. Bull. Univ. Cincinnati, 1926, 5: 56-61.—Hyde, C. L. The clinical application of heliotherapy and artificial light with a description of a carbon arc installation. Tr. Nat. Tuberc. Ass,_N. Y, 1928, 24: 127-35, 4 pl—Jackson, J. A., & Cham- berlain, L. R. Heliotherapy in the treatment of mental patients. Med. J. & Rec, 1927, 126: 731-4— Kieffer, J. The biological and clinical significance of heliotherapy in dentistry. Am. Dent. Surgeon, 1927, 47: 20-30.—Koopal, A. A. [Sun-therapy] Tegen de tuberculose, 1938, 34: 81-9.— Landeker, A. Die vaginale Heliotherapie nach Landeker bei gynakologischen Erkrankungen. Internat. Radiother, Darmst., 1927-28, 3: 1053-80. ------ L'elioterapia vaginale, secondo il metodo di Landeker, nelle affezioni ginecologiche. Arch. HELIOTHERAPY 455 HELIOTHERAPY radiol. Nap, 1929, 5: 903-16.—Leo, G. Heliotherapie ou nhototherapie? spectre solaire total, ou spectre special des fampesen quartz? Clinique, Par 1927 22: 127 -Mayer E. Heliotherapy. In Clin. Tuberc. (B. Goldberg) 2 ed, Phila, 1939 2: E3-43.—Murphy, J. F. X. The fundamentals of heliotherapy in clinical dentistry. Dent. Cosmos, 1935, 77: 29_35__River, G. Heliotherapie et chirurgie. J. med. Paris, 1926 45: 531-3.—Rollier, A. Sonnen- und Luftbehandlung nichttuberkuloser chirurgischer Affektionen mit Einschluss der Kriegsverletzungen. Beitr. klin. Chir, 1916, 100: Kriegs- chir H. 4, 149-83.—Stanganelli, P. Indicazioni e hmiti dell'elioterapia naturale. Morgagni, 1926, 68: 1601-16. _____ Elioterapia naturale o artificiale? Studium, Nap, 1927, 17: 27-34.—Sunshine; what is it? what are its effects on the human organism, and what is its place in medicine? use of artificial sources. Ther. Notes, Detr, 1935, 42: 39-47 — Tisdall, F. F, & Brown, A. Antirachitic value of the sun's ravs through various special window glasses. Am. J. Dis. Child 1927, 34: 742-52.—Woringer, P. L'azione del sole sulle malattie infettive. Clin, pediat. Mod, 1927, 9: 628-40. .--- Indication, pediatric. Bardisian, A. L'elioterapia nella prima infanzia. Med. ital, Milano, 1928, 9: 462-79.—Barraud, G. La sursaturation en puericulture heiio-marine. Arch. med. enf, 1928, 31: 224-9.—Huldschinsky, K, Ledent, R. [et al.] Helio- et actinotherapie en medecine infantile. In Traite helio & actin. (Brody, C.) Par, 1938, 2: 849-98.—Humphris, F. H. Sun- light and the psychology of the child. Hosp. Social Serv, 1928, 17: 127-30.—Marotta, A. La cura di sole nelle malattie deH'i'nfanzia. Morgagni, 1926, 68: 705-15.—Rollier, A. Heliotherapy as applied to the child. Hosp. Social Serv, 1926, 14: 1-9, 6 pl. Also Irish J. M. Sc, 1928, 6. ser, 117-23 — Schultz, F. W. Heliotherapy and actinotherapy in relation to pediatrics. Am. J. Dis. Child, 1926, 32: 900; 1927, 33: 122. --- Indication, preventive. Klein, A., & Herz, L. F. How to suntan for health and fun. 135p. 8? Emaus, Pa. [1938] Muller, J. P. My sun-bathing and fresh-air system. 127p. 8? Lond. [1927] Peters, E. Menschen in der Sonne; von der Heilkraft des Lufts- und Sonnenbades. 2. Aufl. 99p. 8? Stuttg. [1935] Suren, H. Der Mensch und die Sonne. 75. Aufl. 223p. 8? Stuttg. [1925] Aimes, A, Brody, C, & Ledent, R. Heliotherapie et hy- giene generale; heliotherapie preventive. Rapp. Congr. internat. hyg. mediter. (1932) 1933, 1. Congr, 2: 661-6 — Aimes, A, Brody, C. [et al.l Helio- et actinotherapie preven- tives et hygiene. In Traite helio & actin. (Brody, C.) Par, 1938, 1: 724-50.—Armand-Delille, P. F. Le r61e de la lumiere Bolaire dans la croissance de l'enfant et l'equihbre physiolo- gique de l'adulte. Rev. hyg. Par, 1924, 46: 1186791.—--- A propos du role de l'heiiotherapie et des sterols irradies dans la calcification dentaire et la prophylaxie de la cane. Rev. stomat. Par, 1930, 32: 430. ------ Le role de la lumiere solaire et de l'exercice sur la regulation du metabolisme de la nutrition dans la seconde enfance. Nutrition, Par, 1932, 2: 51-8.—Brown, W. H. Hygiene of air and sunshine. In Pract. Libr. M. & S. (Appleton) N. Y, 1937 12: 116-28- Carruthers, Z. M. The sunshine shoppe. Mother & Child, 1923, 4: 517-23.—Delaria, A. L'elioterapia apphcata a scopo profilattico sociale nei preventorio. Pediatria vRiv.) 1934, 42: 362-73—Fougerat de Lastours. L'insolation, moyen d'hygiene. J. med. Paris, 1927, 46: 714-7. ------ L hy- giene solaire aux colonies. Rev. med. hyg. trop, Far, 1927 19: 137-44.—Funk, J. C. Back to nature and the sun. Pennsylvania Health, 1935, 13: 13-6—Haertl, P. Gesundheit durch Sonne fur jedermann, zu jeder Zeit! Kongrber Internat. Kongr. Lichtforsch, 1936, 3. Congr, 714-9. Also Med. Welt, 1936, 10: 598-601.—Holmes, M. E. Curative power of the sun bath. Health Cult, N. Y, 1942, 48: 17.—Isella, A. Elioprofilassi ed elioterapia nella pratica medica. Boll, ron- amb. Giuseppe Ronzoni, 1936, 10: 255-70.—Kellogg, J. H. Find health in the sunshine. Good Health, 1938 73: 134-7. -----Let the summer sun tan your skin. Ibid, 1VMH, /*: 168.—Kenrick, G. W, & Del Toro, G., jr. Studies in solar radiation and their relationship to biophysics and the .general problem of climate and health. Puerto Rico J- Pub. Health 1939-40, 15: 387-419.—Kestner, O. Mensch, Strahlung und Klima. Strahlentherapie, 1928, 28: 52-5—Knox S. G. Meet Dr Sun. Health, Mount. View, 1940, 7: No. 7 14.— Laurens, H. Sunlight and health. Sc. Month, 1936, 42: 312-24.—McKinney, M. Winter sun baths for baby. Pub. Health Nurs, 1940, 32: 92-4.—Mazzeo, M. Sole e salute. Fol. med. Nap, 1938, 24: 61-80—Messerli, F. M. Observa- tions faites lors des cures preventives de soleil. Kongrber. Internat. Kongr. Lichtforsch, 1936, 3. Congr, 659-69 — Palit, C. C, Kaul, R. K, & Dhar, N. R. Comparative influence of sunlight, iron preparations and vitamins in the maintenance of health. J. Phys. Chem, 1930, 34: 737-42-Saleeby. From heliotherapy to heliohygiene. Rapp. Conf. internat. lumiere (1928) 1929, 1. Conf, 508-22.—Salmont A. Lumiere, hygiene et sante. Rev. hyg. Par, 1937, 16: 289-306- Sunlight and health. J. Am. M. Ass, 1936, 106: 2071.— Tisdall, F. F. Sunlight and health. Am. J. Pub. Health, 1926, 16: 694-9. ------ Sunlight and health. Nat. M. J. China, 1926-27, 13: 350-8.—Veeger, L. A. [Sun baths and public health] Tschr. sociale hyg, 1933, 35: 393-5.—Woringer, P. El valor profihictico de la luz. Cron. med. mex, 1930, 29: 210-6. ---- Injurious effect. See also Dermatitis; Light, Pathology; Sun- light, Effect, &c. Larabt, M. *L'action cancerigene de la lumiere solaire. 87p. 8? Par., 1932. Vignolles, R. *Des meiaits du soleil sur l'organisme humain. 167p. 8? Par., 1934. Aimes, A. Accidents de l'heiio et de l'actinotherapie. In Traite helio & actin. (Brody, C.) Par, 1938, 1: 771-88.— Bechet, P. E. Excessive solar and phototherapeutic irradia- tion; a causative factor in certain diseases of the skin. Arch. Derm. Syph, Chic, 1934, 29: 221-7. Also repr.—Boussi. Les accidents oculaires au cours de l'heiiotherapie. J. med. Paris, 1934, 54: 149.—Brustmann, M. Wert und Gefahren der Sonnenbader. Zschr. iirztl. Fortbild, 1937, 34: 406-8 — C, J. Les accidents oculaires de l'heiiotherapie. Presse med, 1933, 41: 2120.—Clement, R. Les accidents des bains de soleil. Ibid, 1935, 43: 430-3—Crehange, J. L, & Rosenthal. Der- matite bulleuse striee consecutive aux bains de soleil dans les pres. Bull. Soc. fr. derm, syph, 1933, 40: 1261-3.—Dognon. Les dangers de l'heiiotherapie. Sciences, Par, 1936-37, 64: 307-10.—Dorno, C. Beitrage zur Kenntnis des Sonnen- und Quarzlicht-Erythems und -Pigmentes. Strahlentherapie, 1926, 22: 70-91.—Elfond, M. A. [Case of peculiar changes in the skin of a man caused by the sun] Vener. derm, Moskva, 1929, 6: 36-41.—Eller, J. J. A case for diagnosis (dermatitis actinica caused by the rays of the sun) Arch. Derm. Syph, Chic, 1937, 36: 383.—Foveau de Courmelles, F. The dangers of spectral ray therapy; heliopathy and heliotherapy. Phys. Ther, 1929, 47: 267-78.—Gamier, G. Bains de soleil et dermatoses. Gaz. med. France, 1939, 46: 801-6.—Haeberlin, C. Vor- und Nachteile der Sonnenbader. Fortsch. Ther, 1930, 6: 358-62.—Hannan, J. Peripheral neuritis as a sequel to sun-bathing. Brit. M. J, 1937, 1: 73.—Healthful and harmful effects of sunshine. Connecticut Health Bull, 1935, 49: 117-20.—Heiner, L. [Dangers of sun baths] Budapesti orv. ujs, 1936, 34: 641-6.—Herlitz, C. W, Jundell, I. [et al.] Weitere Beobachtungen betreffs Lichtschadigungen. Acta paediat, Upps, 1932-33, 14: 606-14.—Jausion, H. Les affections, surtout cutanees, engendrees par la lumiere du soleil. Rev. cosmobiol, Nice, 1938-39, 4:92-6.—Jundell,I,Svedenius, G, & Bjerlov, H. Ueber eventuelle Schiidigungen des Herzens durch natiirliche und kunstliche Lichtbader. Acta paediat, Upps, 1932-33, 14: 404-11.—Kirch, A. Ueber das Auftreten von dunklem Harn bei Menschen mit Dermatitis infolge Be- sonnung. Wien. klin. Wschr, 1930, 43: 560.—Kovtunovich, G P, & Vadova, A. V. [Blastomogenous properties of sun- rays] Sovet. med, 1941, 5: No. 3, 27.—Kren, O. Was haben wir von den intensiven, jetzt modern gewordenen Sonnen- bestrahlungen in Bezug auf die Gesichtshaut zu erwarten? Wien. klin. Wschr, 1937, 50: 1528.—Lemos, M. de. O abuso dos banhos de sol nas nossas praias e o cancer da peile. Rev. med. cir. Brasil, 1934, 42: 165-79.—Mathieu de Fossey, A. Troubles hepato-digestifs consecutifs aux bains de soleil ex- cessifs et mal diriges. J. med. Paris, 1933, 53: 60-6. Also Presse therm, clim, 1933, 74: 53-9—Risler, J, & Foveau de Courmelles. Sur le choc radiant. Bull. sc. pharm. Par, 1927, 34: annexe, 111.—Rono, A. H. Teneur en cholestenne de la peau du foetus et de l'enfant en relation avec l'irradiation solaire. J. physiol. path, gin., 1932, 30: 345. ------; Action canceri- gene des irradiations solaires. Atti Congr. mternaz. e!ettro: radiobiol, 1934, 1: 484-504. ------ Insorgenza di tumori. maligni da irradiazione solare totale. Pathologica, Genova, 1935 27: 443-61. ------ Carcinomas y sarcomas desarro- llado's en las patas, y con localizaciones multiples por las radiaciones solares. Bol. Inst. med. exp. cancer, B. Air, 1935, 12- 529-69 ------ Les bains de soleil et leurs dangers. Rev. cosmobiol, Nice, 1935-36, 2: 99.—Schreiber G. Une ieune fille medusee. Presse med, 1933, 41: 2121—Sezary, A, Joseph, R, & Bolgert, M. Atrophie cutanee aprSs action prolongee des rayons solaires. Bull. Soc. fr. derm syph, 1934, 41: 1685-90.—Stursberg, H. Zur Kenntnis der Gefahren.von Sonnenbestrahlung. Deut. med. Wschr, 1937, 63: 936.— Weber F P. Scarring from exposure to the sun. rroc. ft. Soc. M, Lond, 1937-38, 31: 84.-Zorn R. Trois cas de dermite des bains de soleil dans les pr6s. Bull. Soc. fr. derm. syph, 1936, 43: 1731. ---- Instruments. Bellantoni, R. Cenni sull'elioterapia con filtri e luce naturale Raggi ultraviol, 1926, 2: 242-4. Also Policlinico, 1927 34: fez* prat., 601-3.-Hartmann, P. Neuartiges Liegezelt mit drehbarer Wandung. Deut. med. Wschr, 1927 53: 1783.— Hofhauer G Eine Einrichtung zur Vv irkungssteigerung der "Sligen SonneLtrahlung. Wien. klin. Wschr, 1940 53: 197 —Kime J W. A new instrument for the use of helio- therapy in tuberculosis and other affections. Med. J. & Rec, 1926, 123: 164-6.—Stocbarger, D. C, & Johnson, L. B. HELIOTHERAPY 456 HELIOTHERAPY Comparison between artificial and natural solarization and stabilization of special ultraviolet transmitting glasses com- mercially on the market. J. Franklin Inst, 1930, 210: 455- 60.—Tracy, M. A heliotherapy tent. Am. J. Nurs, 1927, 27: 451.—Weidman, R. E. Sun bath cabinet. U. S. Patent Off, 1937, No. 2,080.044.—Window glass substitutes and sunlight therapy. Brit. M. J, 1927, 2: 556. ---- Mechanism of action. Bernhard, O. Insolation et climat. Praxis, Bern, 1931, 20: No. 27, 1; 3.-—Bertocchi, A. Del potere di penetrazione dei raggi calorifici del sole di alta montagna attraverso i tessuti dell'uomo. Boll. Soc. ital. biol. sper, 1927, 2: 76-80. Also Arch, fisiol, 1929, 27: 215-28.—Ceresole, G. Elioterapia e fattori climatici. Rapp. Conf. internat. lumiere (1928) 1929, 1. Conf, 366-84 [Discussion] 386.—Clasasens, J. D. M. The action of sun and air baths. S. Afr. M. Rec, 1926, 24: 405.— Dorno, C. Physikalische Grundlagen der Sonnen- und Licht- therapie. Med. Welt, 1927, 1: 1292; 1348.—Fleming, W. D. The anti-rachitic efficiency of skyshine in Washington, D. C. Mil. Surgeon, 1928, 53: 658-72.—Gauvain, H. Reflections on sun treatment: the theory of varying stimuli and varying response. Practitioner, Lond, 1934,132:156-65.—Gotz, F. W. P. Die hohen Atmospharenschichten als Lichtfilter und Lichtspender. Kongrber. Internat. Kongr. Lichtforsch, 1936, 3. Congr, 677-82.—Kartschagin, W. Der photoelektrische Effekt der Haut bei Sonnenbadern. Zschr. ges. phvs. Ther, 1927-28, 34: 203-10.—Kellogg, J. H. Miracle-working sun- light: the magical healing power of light. Good Health, 1938, 73: 201.—Laguna, A. Acci6n terapeutica de la luz solar. Inform, med, Valladolid, 1927, 4: 157-65.—Latarjet, R. Influence de l'ozone atmospherique sur l'heiiotherapie. Kongr- ber. Internat. Kongr. Lichtforsch, 1936, 3. Congr, 47-52.— Linke. Die Sonnen- und Himmelsstrahlung und ihre biokli- matische Bedeutung. Miinch. med. Wschr., 1927, 74: 1203.— Linke, F, Latarjet, R. [et al.] Les bases physiques et biologiques de l'heiiotherapie. Rev. physiother. Par, 1936, 12: 286-92.— Meyer, E. G. Ueber die therapeutische Wirkung des Sonnen- bades. Med. Welt, 1938, 12: 1705.—Mezernitsky, P. G. Le mecanisme d'action des bains de soleil. C. rend. Soc. biol, 1927, 97: 1220. Also Zschr. ges. phys. Ther, 1929, 37: 92-8 — Saidman, J. De Taction thermogene du rayonnement solaire concentre. Ann. Inst, actin. Par, 1935-36, 10: 174-8. Also Bull. Acad, med. Par, 1936, 3. ser, 115: 710-4. Also Med. ibera, 1936, 30: pt 2, 328.—Suring, R. Forschungsmethoden der Sonnen- und Himmelsstrahlung. Strahlentherapie, 1928- 29, 31: 325-9.—Tisdall, F. F, & Brown, A. Seasonal variation of the antirachitic effect of sunshine. Am. J. Dis. Child, 1927, 34: 721; 737; 1928, 36: 734.—Wasserfallen. Les bases scientifi- ques de l'heiiotherapie. Praxis. Bern, 1936, 25: 367-70.— Zanoli, R. Osservazioni metereologiche e di elio-climato- terapia. Riv. idrol. clim, 1934, 14: 1-8. ---- Results, and evaluation. Andrews, L. L. The value of actinotherapy and heliotherapy. J. Florida M. A-s. 1930-31, 17: 466-8.—Bernhard, O. Fiinf- undzwanzig Jahre Heliotherapie chirurgischer Affektionen. Strahlentherapie, 1928, 28: 211-26. ------ Dreissig Jahre Heliotherapie im Hochgebirge. Deut. med. Wschr, 1934, 60: 1103-5.—Friedrich, W. Physikalische und biologische Be- wertung therapeutischer Lichtquellen. Fundam. radiol. Berl, 1939, 4: 68-73.—Isella, A. I risultati a distanza del- l'elioterapia. Boll. spec. med. chir, 1930, 4: 112-34.—Klare, K. Betrachtungen uber Wandlungen in der Bewertung der Helio- therapie. Miinch. med. Wschr, 1929, 76: 1291. Achtzehn Jahre Heliotherapie im deutschen Hochgebirge. Kongrber. Internat Kongr. Lichtforsch, 1936, 3. Congr. 187-95—Omeliants, A. P. [Results of concentrated helio- therapy during 4 years] Fizioterapia, Moskva, 1939, No. 6, 6-15—Piedi, F. Su alcuni esperimenti di elioterapia coll'ausilio di un nuovo preparato protettivo il Delial. Gior. ital. mal. esot, 1936, 9: 277-90.—Vignard & Jouffray. Documents sur la cure solaire. Avenir med. Par, 1938, 35: 265; 292. ---- Technic. Josephson, O. J. *Les progres re'eents de l'heiiotherapie; la m6thode du solarium Tournant [Paris] 32p. 8? Corbeil, 1933. Leib, R. *La superiority de l'heiiotherapie moderne (mdthode Brady) sur 1'ancienne techni- que heiiotherapique (mdthode Rollier) 87p. 8° Par., 1936. Aimes, A. Technique general du bain de soleil. Rev actin. Par, 1926, 2: 204-9.—Brody, C. Ueber einige Mittel] die Sonnenkur abzukurzen und sie wirksamer zu machen Strahlentherapie, 1930-31, 39: 764-79. ------ Association systematique de l'heiio- et de l'actinotherapie. Rapp Congr internat. physiother, 1930, 5. Congr, Sect. 5, No 5 44-63 [i?SCu^S0nJ,«9^?nd- 1931, I?5-. Abo Arch- aeetr- m2Cm. Quakenbriick, R. Kleinert, 1937. HELLER, Margarete, 1902- ♦Gewerbe- krankheiten und Zahnheilkunde unter Beriick- sichtigung der neuen Verordnung des Reichs- arbeitsministeriums. 37p. 8? Bonn, L. Neuen- dorff [1926] HELLER, Martin, 1900- ♦Ein Beitrag zur Vererbung im Bereiche des menschlichen Gebisses [Tubingen] 34p. 8? Babenhausen, J. Kreutzer & Co., 1934. HELLER, Robert. Caisson sickness; a mono- graph; transl. from the German by M. C. Roemer. 84 1. roy. 8? Wash. [1912] Typewritten. HELLER, Rudolf, 1909- ♦Ueber die Behandlung des fieberhaften Abortus. 21p. 8? Tiib., A. Becht, 1935. HELLER, Theodore, 1869- Grundriss der Hedpadagogik. 3. Aufl. vii, 767p. 8? Lpz., \V. Engelmann, 1926. For biography see Zschr. Kinderforsch, 1929, 35: 453 (M. Isserlin) HELLER, Theodore. ♦Puis, Atemfrequenz und Atemtiefe nach dosierter Arbeit zur Priifung der Leistungsfahigkeit des Herzens. 13p. 2 tab 8° Stetten, K. Schahl, 1936. HELLERMANN, Walter, 1902- ♦Histo- rische Studie zur Erforschung der Innervation des Uterus mit einem Anhange iiber ihre Dar- stellungsmethoden [Erlangen] 76p. tab. 8° Berl., E. Ebering, 1927. HELLER'S dementia. See Dementia, schizophrenic, infantile. HELLERSTROEM, Sven [Curl Alfred] 1901- A contribution to the knowledge of lympho- granuloma inguinale. 224p. 13 pl. 8? Stockli P. A. Norstedt & Soner, 1929. Forms Suppl. 1, Acta derm, vener. HELLESDON, Norwich. Norwich City Asy. lum. Annual report. Hellesdon, 1.-2., 1SS0 si" 4.-5., 1883-84. HELLFORS, Alfred [Robert Wilhelm] 1901- ♦Die Saure-Umscnlag-Alkali-Methode und ihre Verwertbarkeit als Nierenfunktionsprufung in der inneren Klinik [Berlin] 23p. 8? Charlot- tenb., Gebr. Hoffmann, 1927. HELLFRITSCH, Max, 1900- ♦Ueber den Einfluss der Narkose auf den osmotischen Druck des Blutserums und seine Regulierung. 23p. 8? Wiirzb., P. Kilian & Co., 1926. HELLFRITZ, Ulrich [Peter Max Berthold] 1909- ♦Ueber einen seltenen Fall von Harnblasendivertikel. 22p. 8? Rostock, C. Hinstorff, 1933. HELLGE, Erich, 1904- ♦Schul-Zahn- pflege und soziale Hygiene [Tubingen] 20p. 8? Stuttg., K. Weinbrenner & Sohne, 1930. HELLGE, Walter, 1901- ♦Ueber die Grundsatze, die arztlicherseits beim Bau und der Einrichtung von Krankenanstalten fiir Tuberkulose aufzustellen sind [Tubingen] 30p. 8? Stuttg., K. Weinbrenner & Sohne, 1927. HELLHAMMER, Fritz, 1910- ♦Inter- suchung iiber Zahn- und Mundschleimhaut- erkrankungen bei der Hitler-Jugend der Unter- banne I. u. II. des Bannes 99 unter Beriick- sichtigung sozialer Verhaltnisse [Munster i. W.] 13p. 8? Bottrop, W. Postberg, 1935. HELLICH, Use, 1900- ♦Zur Kenntnis akuter und atypischer Leukamien. 61p. 2 tab. 8? Rostock, Winterberg, 1931. HELLIESEN, Henrik, 1895- +Die freie Knochenverpflanzung im Dienste der Kiefer- chirurgie [Berlin] 31p. 3 pl. 8? Charlottenb., Gebr. Hoffmann, 1927. HELLIN, Dyonizy, 1867-1935. Goldbaum, M. [Obituary] Warsz. czaa. lek, 1935, 12: 789, portr. HELLING, Heinrich, 1906- *Akute ge- schlossene Mittelohrentziindung mit symptomless auftretendem retroaurikularem Durchbruch. p.48-79. 8? Marb. [n. pub.] 1931. Also Arch. Ohr. &c. Heilk, 1931-32, 130: HELLINGER [Karl] Martin, 1904- ♦Bei- trag zur Pathologie und Therapie der Mikrogna- thie [Leipzig] 92p. 8? [Zeulenroda, A. Ober- reuter] 1928 HELLKAMP, Fritz, 1891- ♦Zahn- und Mundverhaltnisse bei Fiirsorgeempfangern zwi- schen 40 und 60 Jahren. 31p. 8? Bonn, P. Kubens, 1933. HELLMAN, C. Doris. Legendre and the French reform of weights and measures, p.314- 40. fase. 8? Bruges, S. Catherine Press, 1936. In Osiris, Bruges, 1936, 1: HELLMAN, Torsten J., 1878- *Den lymfoida vafnadens normala mangd hos kanin i olika postfetala aldrar; bidrag till konstitutions- fragen darjamte en kritisk ofversikt af litteratur rorande den lymfoida vafnadens mangd under olika forhallanden. 408p. xxiii, 2 pl. 8 ch. 8? Upsala, E. Berling, 1914. ---- & SCHUMACHER, S. [et al] Ver- dauungsapparat, Mundhohle; Speichel drusen; Tonsillen; Rachen; Speiserohre; Serosa, vii, 374p. 8? Berl., J. Springer, 1927. Forms pt 1, v.5, Handb. mikr. Anat. Menschen (von Mollendorff) Berl., 1927. HELLMANN 459 HELLPACH HELLMANN, Karl Eberhardt, 1907- *Ueber den Einfluss von Bromacetat, Fluorid und Oxalat auf die Vergarung von Lavulose durch verschiedene Hefen [Munster] 20p. 21cm. Werne a. d. Lippe, F. Grube, 1936. HELLMANN, Konrad, 1907- ♦Erfah- rungen iiber die klinische Brauchbarkeit der Aminosaureausscheidung nach Gelatinebelastung als Leberfunktionsprufung. 31p. 8? Munch., P. Waizmann, 1934. HELLMANN, Lisbeth, 1907- ♦Zur Be- handlung des malignen Chorionepithelioms unter besonderer Berucksichtigung der an der Heidel- berger Universitatsfrauenklinik behandelten Falle [Heidelberg] 16p. 8? Bottrop, W. Postberg, 1934. HELLMANN, Rudolf, 1905- ♦Ueber die diagnostische Bedeutung der Knochenleitung. 30p. 8? Rostock, C. Hinstorff, 1930. HELLMANN, Simon, 1909- ♦Ueber die histochemischen farberischen Eigenschaften eines Lignocerylsphingosins. 13p. 8? Wiirzb., R. Mayr, 1936. HELLMER, Hans Valentin, 1898- *R6ntgenologische Beobachtungen iiber Ossifika- tion der Patella [Lund] 82p. roy. 8? Stockh., P. A. Norstedt & soner, 1935. Also Acta radiol, Suppl. 27. HELLMER, Herbert, 1911- ♦Zufallige und fahrlassige Vergiftungen durch Schadlings- bekampfungsmittel. 20p. 22}2cm. Heidelb., Brausdruck, 1937. HELLMICH, Walter. Die Eidechsen Chiles, insbesondere die Gattung Liolaemus; nach den Sammlungen Goetsch-Hellmich. 140p. 2 pl. 4? Miinch., C. H. Beck, 1934. Forms n. F, H. 24, Abh. Baver. Akad. Wiss, math, naturw.' Abt. HELLMUND, Use, 1911- *Beitrag zur Haufigkeit und Verlaufsweise des Lupus miliaris disseminatus faciei. 19p. 8? Berl., E. Schmidt, 1936. HELLMUTH, Erna Maria, 1912- ♦Ueber die Wirkung von Thorium auf Kreislauf und Blut. 23p. 8? Wiirzb., L. Popp, 1937. HELLMUTH, Giinter, 1913- ♦Doppel- bildungen im Bereich der Harnwerkzeuge, mit zwei Eigenbeobachtungen je eines Doppelureters mit und ohne Stein. 48p. 23cm. Berl., R. Pfau, 1938. HELLMUTH, Karl. ♦Beitrage zur Biologie des Neugeborenen [Wurzburg] p.293-361. 8? Berl., J. Springer, 1926. Also Arch. Gyn, Berl, 1925-26, 127:-128: HELLMUTH, Karl, 1902- *Ein Beitrag zur Arsenfrage unter besonderer Beriicksichti- gung von Pulparsen. 35p. 8? Wiirzb., L. Popp, 1933. HELLNER, Charlotte [Dorothea Marie Luise] 1901- ♦Kann durch eine Operation die Menstruation in jeder ihrer Phasen ausgelost werden? [Freiburg i. B.] 23p. 8? Stettin, Fischer & Schmidt, 1927. HELLNER, Fritz, 1904- ♦Ueber die Spontanruptur der mucoiden Aorta (Betriebs- unfall) p. 101-15. 8? Berl. [n. pub.] 1933. Also Deut. Zschr. gerichtl. Med, 1933, 22: HELLNER, Hans, 1900- Zur Erkennung und Begutachtung von Schadelgrundbriichen. 43p. 8? Berl., F. C. W. Vogel, 1935. Forms H. 19, Hefte Unfallh. --- Die Knochengeschwiilste. vi, 229p. illust. 25/2cm. Berl., J. Springer, 1938. --- Unfall und Knochengeschwulst. 55p. 24cm. Berl.,F. C. W. Vogel. 1939. Forms H. 25, Hefte Unfallh. HELLPACH, Willy Hugo, 1877- Die Neugestaltung des medizinischen Unterrichts; eine hochschulpadagogische Untersuchung. 94p. 8? BerL, Urban & Schwarzenberg, 1919. ---- Geopsyche; die Menschenseele unterm Einfluss von Wetter und Klima, Boden und Landschaft. 4. Aufl. xvi, 317p. 8? Lpz., W. Engelmann, 1935. HELLPAP, Waldemar, 1907- *Alte und neue Verfahren der Hautnaht. 27p. 22J4cm. Berl., K. & R. Hoffmann, 1937. HELLRIEGEL, Alfred Felix, 1910- *Schnittfiihrung bei Gallenblasenoperationen und Narbenhernien. ISp. 8? Borna, R. Noske, 1936. HELLRIEGEL, Herbert, 1910- ♦Die Practica aus dem Micrologus Richards des Englanders [Leipzig] 64p. 23cm. Zeulenroda, A. Oberreuter, 1934. HELLRIEGEL, Kurt, 1903- ♦Ueber einen Fall von Carcinosarkom des Uterus. 24p. pl. 8? Munch, [n. pub.] 1927. HELLRIEGEL, Martin, 1907- ♦Ueber zwei Fade von Darmverschluss nach vorderer Gastroenterostomie [Heidelberg] 35p. 8? Hep- penheim, J. Weimar, 1933. HELLRIEGEL, Walter, 1909- ♦Experi- mentelle Untersuchungen iiber Necronerv, ein neueres Pulpendevitalisationsmittel mit arseniger Saure als wirksame Substanz [Heidelberg] 27p. 8? Quakenbruck, C. Trute, 1934. HELLRUNG, Alfred. See Rojahn, C. A, & Hellrung, A. Ueber die Identifizierung der in der Homoopathie gebrauchten Trockendrogen. 97p. 22iicm. Halle, 1937. HELLRUNG, Angela, 1911- *Die Bak- teriologie der Zahnwurzel-Granulome; eine kri- tische Wertung [Munster] 25p. 21cm. Werne a. d. Lippe, F. Grube, 1936. HELLSTADIUS, Arvid, 1898- ♦Ueber die Entwicklung des tuberkulosen Prozesses und die Entstehung verschiedener Ausheilungs- formen bei Tuberkulose der Wirbelkorper; sowie einige damit zusammenhangende Verhaltnisse [Stockholm] 182p. 8? Kbh., Levin & Munks- gaard, 1937. HELLSTEN, Oscar Theodor, 1889-1931. Hanson, R. [Obituary] Sven. lak. tidn, 1931, 28: 129-31 HELLSTROEM, John [Gustav Leonard] 1890- Staphylococcus stones; a clinical study of 90 cases. lOlp. 8? Stockh., P. A. Norstedt & soner, 1936. Forms Suppl. 46, Acta chir. scand. ----Zur Kenntnis der Bedeutung der Sen- kungsreaktion und des leukozytaren Blutbildes fiir Diagnose und Prognose bei chirurgischen Krankheiten. 95p. 8? Stockh., P. A. Norstedt & soner, 1937. Forms Suppl. 52, v.80, Acta chir. scand. HELLSTROEM, Nils, 1877-1941. [General Director of the Medical Board 1928-35] Sven. lak. tidn, 1935, 32: 929-31, portr.—Matern, E. [Obituary]. Sven. farm, tskr, 1941, 45: 301. HELLSTROEM, Thure Gustav, 1857-1930. Lichtenstein, A. [Obituary] Sven. lak. tidn, 1930, 27: 529-32.—Wetterdal, H. [Obituary] Hygiea, Stockh, 1930, 92: 321-8. HELLUIN, Lucien, 1907- ♦Le regime de Gerson dans le traitement de la tuberculose. 51p. 8? Par., M. Vigne, 1932. HELLUY, Pierre, 1906- ♦Splenomegalies parasitaires chroniques et splenectomie. 82p. 8? Par., Press. Modern., 1933. HELLWEG, Gisela, 1914- ♦Ueber ein Karzinom des Mediastinums [Munster] 27p. 21cm. Bielefeld, Beyer & Hausknecht, 1937. HELLWEC HELLWEG, Hermann, 1913- ♦Leber stumpfe Thoraxverletzungen; Erfahrungen aus der Chirurgischen Universitatsklinik zu Leipzig in der Zeit vom Januar 1927 bis Februar 1937 [Leipzig] 43p. 8? Zeulenroda, A. Oberreuter, 1937. HELLWIG, Albert Ernst Max, 1880- Okkultismus und Verbrechen, eine Einfiihrung in die kriminalistischen Probleme des Okkultis- mus fiir Polizeibeamte, Richter, Staatsanwiilte, Psychiater und Sachverstandige. 386p. 8 pl. 4? BerL, P. Lagenscheidt, 1929. [HELLWIG, Christoph von] 1663-1721. Be- treuer, sorgfaltiger und beschwinder Kinder- Artzt. 7 p. 1. 448p. [16]p. 16#cm. Frankf., E. L. Niedt, 1722. At head of tp Valentini Krautermanns Med. Pract. Thur. HELLWIG, Hans Wilhelm, 1907- ♦Hat die Kammeranlage fiir die Verankerung totaler Prothesen eine Bedeutung? [Wurzburg] 19p. 8? [BerL, H. Pusch & Co., 1930] HELLWIG, Karl, 1896- *Ueber Adsorp- tion alkalischer Tierkohle gegeniiber Jodkalium. 12p. 8? Giessen, A. Klein. 1926. HELLWIG, Karl, 1902- ♦Ueber die Phlegmone in der Wand des Magen- und Darm- kanals. 23p. 8? Frankf. a. M., Wrerner & Winter, 1927. HELLWIG, Konrad [Georg] 1908- ♦Ist eine Schwangerschaftsunterbrechung durch Hy po- physenvorderlappenhormon moglich? v, 36p. 8? Marb., Gutenberg Dr., 1934. HELLWIG [Martin] Werner, 1911- ♦Augenmuskelparesen, Diplopie und Lebens- dauer. 31p. 23cm. Kiel, K. J. Rossier, 1936. HELLWIG, Wilhelm, 1906- ♦Beitrage zum Problem der Wurzelbehandlung [Wiirz- burg] 32p. 8? Dillingen a. Donau, 1930. HELM, F. Tuberkulose-Heilstatten im Deut- schen Reich. 2 1. 182p. 4? Diisseld., T. P. Braun [1930] HELM, Gunther [Karl] 1913- ♦Die operationslose Bruchbehandlung [Munchen] 32p. 21cm. Bleicherode, C. Nieft, 1938. HELM, Karl, 1907- *Untersuchungen iiber die Trachtigkeitsfeststellung bei der Hiindin durch Hormonnachweis im Harn. 29p. 8°. Giessen, Bischoff [19311 HELM, Otto [Friedrich Wilhelm Louis] 1910- ♦Anaerobier im Wurzelkanal bei Gangran der Zahnpulpa. 27p. 8? Marb., H. Kilber, 1934, HELM, Wolfgang. ♦Ueber ein primares Melanoblastom der Ruckenmarkshaute. 25p. 8? Munch., Hohenhaus, 1936. HELMAN, Beatrice, 1910- ♦Formes cliniques de Fabces latero-pharyngien dans la petite enfance en particulier les formes lentes. 52p. 8? Par., L. Arnette, 1937. HELMAN, Mauricio B. See Tagle, E. C, & Helman, M. B. Edad del ovino. 19p. 26#cm. B. Air., 1938. HELMAN, Socrate, 1909- ♦Contribution k l'etude de l'6tat psychique et nerveux dans un cas de myxoedeme congenital. 37p. 23}^cm Par., Pascal [1939] HELMBOLD [Johann] Hans Wolfgang [Ru- dolf] 1909- ♦Beitrage zur Milchhygiene. 33p. 8? K6nigsb.-Pr., Steinbach, 1936. HELMCHEN, Helmut [Wilhelm Johannes] 1902- *Die Gymnastik als Nachbehand- lung von plastischen Operationen ampHuft- gelenk [Berlin] 22p. 8? [Halle, n. pub.] 1930. HELMCKE HELMCKE, Magdalene (geb. Gdaniec) 1910- ♦Klinische Erfahrungen mit Avortin- Narkosen bei Sauglingen und Kindern in den ersten beiden Lebensjahren [Berlin] 16p. 8° Gutersloh, Thiele, 1936. HELME, Frangois, 1859-1923. Lematte, L. [Necrologie] Rev. prat. mal. pays chauds 1923-24, 3: 249-52. HELMER, Maria, 1911- ♦Anzeige und Anwendung der wichtigsten einheimischen Heil- pflanzen bei Krankheiten der ausseren Haut und des Magen-Darmkanals [Tubingen] 25p. 21cm. Marbach, A. Remppis, 1938. HELMER-DUPIC, M[arie] P., 1891- ♦StSrilite et permeability tubaire. 112p. 8° Par., Lipschutz, 1932. HELMERICH, Elvira, 1905- *Zahn- fieber [Wurzburg] lip. 8? Stuttg., F. Enke, 1929. Also Arch. Kinderh, 1929, 88: 139-45. HELMERT, Willi, 1910- ♦Ueber den Einfluss des Dijodtyrosins auf den Phosphat- stoffwechsel [Munster] 19p. 8? Werne-Lippe, F. Grube, 1934. HELMET. Basset & Pales. Presentation d'un casque. Mem. Acad. chir. Par, 1940, 66: 437.—Boesger, G. A. Helmet. U. S. Patent Off, 1941, No. 2,240,751.—Motor cyclists should wear a crash helmet. J. Am. M. Ass, 1942, 118: 313.—Schneider, J. H. Welder's protective headgear. U. S. Patent Off, 1941, No. 2,229,706.—Steel helmets for hospital workers. Med. Off, Lond, 1941, 66: 148.—Yant, W. P., & Ray, K. B. Hood. U. S. Patent Off, 1941, No. 2,262,522. HELMHOLTZ, Hermann Ludwig Ferdinand von. 1821-94. Natur und Naturwissenschaft. 232p. 8? Miinch., A. Langen, 1925. ---- On thought in medicine (Das Denken in der Medizin) an address delivered August 2, 1877, on the anniversary of the foundation of the Institute for the Education of Army Surgeons. 27p. portr. roy. 8? Bait., Johns Hopkins Press, 1938. See also Warburg, E, Rubner, M, & Schlick, M. Helm- holtz als Physiker, Physiologe und Philosoph; drei Vortrage gehalten "zur Feier seines 100. Geburtstags. 40p. 8". Karls- ruhe, 1922. Also Hague, E. B. Helmholtz in medicine. N. York State J. M, 1941, 41: 2238-41.—Katz, B. Herman von Helmholtz, der Ueberwinder der Romantik. Deut. med. Wschr, 1932, 58: 603. For portrait, photograph see collection in library. HELMHOLZ, Henry Frederic, 1882- , & AMBERG, Samuel. Diseases of the genito- urinary system in infancy and childhood, xii, 239p. 8? N. Y., D. Appleton & co., 1930. HELMICH, Wilhelm, 1903- ♦Verfall und Umgestaltung des realistischen Seelenlebens bei Fr. Th. Vischer und C. F. Meyer [Kiel] 146p. 8? Quakenbruck, R. Kleinert, 1933. HELMING, Bernhard, 1911- ♦Wargols- hausen, ein mainfrankisches Inzuchtsdorf. 33p. illust. 24cm. Wurzb., K. Triltsch, 1937. HELMING, Otto, 1898- ♦Beitrag zur Lehre vom chronischen Delirium bei genuiner Epilepsie und Hirngeschwulst. 36p. 8? Miinst. i. Westf., F. Althoff, 1931. HELMINTHES. See also Nemathelminthes; Plathelminthes; Worms. Tsan, Tsong-Kah. ♦Ueber die heute be- kannten Eingeweidewiirmer des Menschen. 38p. 8? [BerL] 1931. Athias. Description d'un ver parasite de la glande de l'hibernation du herisson. Arch. Inst. bact. Camara Pestana. Lisb, 1908, 2: 133-45, 2 pl.—Becker, E. R. Two observations on helminths. Tr. Am. Micr. Soc, 1933, 52: 361.—Bernard, HELMINTHES 461 HELMINTHES p N Schein, H. [et al.] Les vers intestinaux. Arch. Inst. Pasteur Indochine, 1922, Spec, 110-5.—Cameron, T. W. M. The helminth parasites of animals and human disease. Proc. R Soc. M, Lond, 1926-27, 20: Sect. Comp. Med, 15-24.— Delvoie, P. Quelques m^faits des vers intestinaux. Arch. mid. beiges, 1926, 79: 9-11.—Ginestet, G. A propos de vers intestinaux. Rev. prat. mal. pays chauds, 1929, 9: 664.— Girardi, P. Vermi intestinali. In Med. int. (Ceconi) Tor, 1931, 2: 529-63.—Hodson, V. S. Intestinal worms. J. Trop. M Hve Lond, 1921, 24: 244.—Intestinal helminths. Annual Rep. Calcutta School Trop. M. (1933) 1934, Suppl, 62-70 — Janicki, C. Une theorie nouvelle sur la morphologie g€n6rale des trematodes et des cestodes. C. rend. Soc. biol, 1923, 89: 134O —Joyeux, C. L'etude des helminthiases. Rapp. Congr. Ban. pub., Marseille, 1922, 3. Congr, 7-24.—Leger, M. Tra- vaux sur les cestodes et les trematodes. Gaz. sc. mid. Bor- deaux, 1921, 42: 509-11.—Leiper, R. T. Notes of recent and some new records of helminthes in man of which there are few records. J. London School Trop. M, 1911-12, 1: 16-20 — Mandoul, H. Les vers intestinaux. J. mid. Bordeaux, 1935, 112: 895-8.—Monnig, H. O. Erratic worm parasites in man. S. Afr. M. J, 1934, 8: 475.—Ortlepp, R. J. Some avian and mammalian helminths. Onderstepoort J. Vet. Sc, 1938, 11: 63-104. ------ Some helminths, chiefly from rodents. Ibid, 1939, 12: 75-101.—Piechaud, F. De quelques vers intestinaux frequents chez l'enfant. J. mid. Bordeaux, 1939, 116: 209-22.—Robert. Ueber Eingeweidewiirmer. Allg. med. zentr. Ztg, 1922, 91: 27.—Ruszkowski, J. S. Sur les vers parasites des chimeres. Ann. parasit. Par, 1934, 12: 482-91.—Savazzini, L. A. Nuevas especies de nematodes, cestodes y trematodes hallados en nuestro Leptodactylus. Sem. mid., B. Air, 1928, 35: 24-8.—Two new parasitic worms of Didelphys aurita: Skrjabinofilaria pricei n. sp. and Gongy- lonema marsupialis n. sp. J. Washington Acad. Sc, 1934, 24: 54—Vermes intestinaes. Brasil med, 1924, 38: pt 2, 180-2.— Vuillemin, P. Que sont devenus les helminthes? Rev. mid. est, 1925, 53: 2-6. --- Biology. Baylis, H. A. Helminths and evolution. In Evolution (De Beer, G. R.) Oxf, 1938, 249-70.—Chu, H. J. Certain behavior reactions of Schistosoma japonicum and Clonorchis sinensis in vitro. Chin. M. J, 1938, Suppl. 2, 411-7.—Hoeppli, B Histologische Beitrage zur Biologie der Helminthen. Virchows Arch, 1929, 271: 356-65.—Hsu, H. F, & Li, S. Y. Studies on the food and the digestive system of certain para- sites; on the food of certain helminths living in the digestive tract of vertebrates. Chin. M. J, 1940, 57: 559-07.—Li, H. C. Feeding experiments on representatives of Ascaroidea and Oxyuroidea. China M. J, 1933, 47: 1336-42.—McCoy, O. R. The physiology of the helminth parasites. Physiol. Rev, 1935, des 15: 221-40.—Rebello, S, & Toscano Rico, J. La r^activite helminthes £tudi6e par la mdthode graphique. C. rend. Soc. biol, 1926, 94: 915-8.—Wilhelmi, R. W. Serological reactions and species specificity of some helminths. Biol. Bull, 1940, 79: 64-90. --- Ecology. Blackie, W. K. A helminthological survey of Southern Rhodesia. 91p. 8? Lond., 1932. Leipeb, R. T. Helminthological researches in the Caribbean area. p. 1-122. 8? Lond., 1924. Baer, J. G. Contribution k la faune helminthologique sud- africaine; note pr^liminaire. Ann. parasit. Par, 1924, 2: 239-47. Also Rep. Div. Vet. Educ. Pretoria, 1926, 11:-12: 63-136, map.—Baylis, H. A. Some new parasitic nematodes and cestodes from Java. Parasitology, Lond, 1929, 21: 256-66.—Bernard, P. N., Bablet, J, & Pons, R. Les vers intestinaux en Cochinchine. Bull. Soc. path, exot. Par, 1924, 17: 577-82.—Brug, S. L, & Tesch, J. W. [Parasitic worms in the Lindoe lake (Paloe, Celebes)] Geneesk. tschr. Ned. Indie, 1937, 77: 2151-8.—Ciurea, I. Sur quelques larves des vers parasites de I'homme, des mammiferes et des oiseaux ichtyo- phages, trouvfe chez les poissons des grands lacs de la Bessara- bie, du Dniester et de son liman. Arch, roumain. path. Par, 1933, 6: 151-70, 13 pl.—Davies, T. I, & Evans, R. Report on helminths collected from an Indian chukar, with descriptions of 2 new species of Raillietina Fuhrmann 1920. Parasitology, Lond, 1938, 30: 419-26.—Fisher, A. C. A survey of the in- testinal helminths of Yakusu, Haut Congo Beige. J. Hel- minth, Lond, 1934, 12: 221-4.—Grieder, H. In der Schweiz selten vorkommende Helminthen als pathogene Wirbeltier- parasiten. Zschr. Parasitenk, 1936-37, 9: 145-50.—Henry, A, & Joyeux, C. Contribution k la faune helminthologique de la Haute-Guinee francaise. Bull. Soc. path, exot. Par, 1920,13: 176-82.—Joyeux, C, & Baer, J. G. Note sur quelques helminthes recoltes en Macedoine. Ibid, 1928, 21: 214-20. -----& Martin, R. Sur quelques helminthes de la Somalie- Nord. Ibid, 1937, 30: 416-23.—Joyeux, C, & Houdemer, E. Recherches sur la faune helminthologique de l'lndochine (cestodes et trematodes) Ann. parasit. Par, 1927, 5: 289; 1928, 6: 27.—Kalantarian, E. W. Zur Kenntnis der Helmin- thenfauna des Nor-Bajazetschen Bezirkes. Arch. Schiffs Tropenhyg, 1927, 31: 438-40.—Lent, H., & Teixeira de Freitas, J. F. Contribuicao ao conhecimento da fauna hel- minthologica da Argentina (Graphidioides mazzai n. sp. R™a?if^oo! £alea leucoblephara (Burm.) Rev. med. cir. Brasil 1935, 43: 225-7.—Orlova, E. V. [Results of helmintho- logical investigations of the water of the river Penzal Med parazit, Moskva, 1940, 9: 238-44.—Ortlepp, R. J. South African helminths. Onderstepoort J. Vet. Sc, 1937 9- 311- 36.—Pereira & Ferreira Pinto, C. Notas sobre a distribuicSo geographica dos helminthos no Rio Grande do Sul. Brasil med, 1919, 33: 124.—Ribeiro, D. J. Contribuicao para o conhecimento da fauna helmintol6gica de Minas Gerais- Eurytrema minensis n. sp, parasito de Dasypus novemcinctus L. Rev. brasil. biol, 1941, 1: 235-7.—Solomon, S. G. Hel- minths from Cyprus. J. Helminth, Lond, 1932, 10: 1-14 pl — Teixeira de Freitas, J. F., Lant, H, & Lins de Almeida, J. Pequena contribuicao ao estudo da fauna helmintologica da Argentina. Mem. Inst. Oswaldo Cruz, 1937, 32: 195-209, 13 pl.—Travassos, L. Informacoes sobre o material hel- nunthologico colleccionado na Ilha da Trindade em 1916. Arch. Mus. nac. Rio de Janeiro, 1919, 22: 161-92. ------ Informacoes sobre a fauna helminthologica sul-fluminense. Brasil med, 1916, 30: 1 313. ------ Informacoes sobre a fauna helminthologica de Matto Grosso. Fol. med, Rio, 1922, 3: 187 passim. ------ Contribuicao para o conheci- mento da fauna helminthologica sul-fluminense. Brasil med, 1918, 32: 289. ------ Contribuicoes para o conheci- mento da fauna helmintologica brazileira. Mem. Inst. Oswaldo Cruz, 1919, 11: 71 1926, 19: 31; 24 pl. ------ Contribuicoes para o conhecimento da fauna helmintolojica dos batraquios do Brasil. Sciencia med, Rio, 1925, 3: 673-87. ------ Relat6rio da terceira excursao a zona da Estrada de Ferro Noroeste do Brasil realizada em fevreiro e marco de 1940. Mem. Inst. Oswaldo Cruz, 1940, 35: 607-96, 9 pl.—Van Cleave, H, & Mueller, J. F. A biological and ecological survey of the worm parasites. Roosevelt Wild Life Ann, 1934, 7: 161- 334.—Wehr, E. E. Helminth parasites of mammals in the Philippine Islands. Philippine J. Sc, 1930, 41: 261-72.— Zotta, G. Faune helminthologique humaine en Roumanie; helminthes rares ou nouveaux en parasitologic roumaine. C. rend. Soc. biol, 1928, 98: 1450. --- Ovum. Antipa, G. Un proc<5d<§ plus rapide pour la preparation microscopique des ceufs des helminthes. Bull. Acad, roumain, 1920-22, 7: sect, sc, 124-7.—Augustine, D. L, Nazmi, M. [et al.] The ova-parasite ratio for Ancylostoma duodenale and Ascaris lumbricoides. J. Parasit, Urbana, 1928-29, 15: 45-51.—Basnuevo, J. G., & Anido, V. Manera de conservar huevos de helmintos. Rev. med. trop. parasit, Habana, 1938, 4: 159.—Blaschin, A. N. Beobachtungen der Eier von Parasitenwiirmern auf einem dunkeln oder kontrastierenden Grund. Arch. Schiffs Tropenhyg, 1931, 35: 363-5.—Maeda, M. Ueber die in den menschlichen Faces enthaltenen unbe- kannten Parasiteneier und ihr Wesen. Fukuoka acta med, 1928, 21: 82.—Nicholls, L., & Gunawardana, S. A. The destruction of helminth ova in night soil by composting. Ceylon J. Sc, 1939, 5: 1-8, pl.—Ogata, S. Ueber die Ver- nichtung der Eier der Darmparasiten. Tr. Jap. Path. Soc, 1926, 16: 111.—Sankin, S. L. Zur Methodik der Herstellung haltbarer Dauerpriiparate von Eiern parasitischer Wiirmer. Arch. Schiffs Tropenhyg, 1929, 33: 416.—Scott, J. A. The effect of various solutions on helminth eggs in feces. J. Parasit, Lancaster, 1937, 23: 109-12. Also repr.—Vasilkova, Z. G. | Vitality of the helminth eggs in ditches] Med. parazit, Moskva, 1940, 9: 231-7. ---- Ovum: Counting. See also Helminthosis, Diagnosis. Muller [P.] H. *Vergleichende Untersu- chungen iiber den Nachweis von Helminth en eiern nach den verschiedenen Methoden bei Hund und Katze. 44p. 21cm. Lpz., 1936. Zibell, F. A. O. *Vergleichende Unter- suchungen einiger neuen Verfahren zum Nach- weis von Helminth en eiern. 30p. 8? [Rostock] 1926. Blount, W. P. Observations on the modified Gordon- Whitlock method for the counting of helminth ova in horse faeces. J. R. Army Vet. Corps, 1940-41, 12: 69-78— Dechigi- Declich, Melchiorre, & Pincherle, B. Ricerche di raffronto sul valore diagnostico dei metodi coprologici di arricchimento delle uova nelle infestationi dell'uomo e degli animali. Clin, pediat. Mod, 1929, 11: 585-645, ch, 4 pl.—De Rivas, D. An efficient and rapid method of concentration for the detection of ova and cysts of intestinal parasites. Am. J. Trop. M, 1928, 8: 63-72.—Galli-Valerio. Technik der Gewinnung und mikro- skopischen Untersuchung auf Helminthen-Eier und Larven. Schweiz. med. Wschr, 1929, 59: 494—Kortenhaus, F. Ver- besserter Nachweis von Wurmeiern im aufgehellten dicken Trockenkotausstrich. Munch, med. Wschr, 1928, 75: 1029.— Kudriavtzev, V. I, & Shensnovich, V. B. [Examinations of stools for ova in mass examinations of the population] Vest. mikrob, 1930, 9: 427-36.—Letulle, M. The detection of the ova of intestinal parasites in the faeces. Internat. Clin, 1907, 17. ser, 2: 74-8, 6 pl.—Lima, A. R. V. Meio rapido para revelar ovulos de parasitas intestinaes nas fezes. Brasil med. HELMINTHES 1913, 27: 427.—Lins, A. E. E. Ovohelmintoscopias. Bol. Seer, saude, Rio, 1936, 2: No. 5, 83-93, 5 pl.—Mendheim, H. Ueber eine zweckmiissige Abanderung der Looss'schen Schut- telmethode nebst Bemerkungen zur helminthologischen Tech- nik. Zschr. Parasitenk, 1938-39, 10: 436.—Najera, L. Una nuova tecnica per la numerazione di uova di elminti nelle feci. Diagn. teen, lab. Nap, 1932, 3: 373.—Nieschulz, O, & Hofkamp, H. S. Ueber den Wert der sogenannten D.-C.-F.- Methoden von Lane als Anreicherungsverfahren fiir Nema- todeneier und Kokzidienzysten. Deut. tierarztl. Wschr, 1930, 38: 116.—Nitzulesco, V., Manoilesco, C, & Popovici, R. Sur la recherche des oeufs d'helminthes par la mdthode de Willis-Hung. Bull. Acad. mid. Roumanie, 1939, 4: 86-99.— Pessoa, S. B, & Pascale, H. Sobre o metodo de Stoll-Hausher para a contagem de ovos nas fezes. Arq. hig, S. Paulo, 1941, 6: No. 11, 13-22.—Peters, B. G., & Leiper, J. W. G. Variation in dilution-counts of helminth eggs. J. Helminth, S. Albans, 1940, 18: 117-42.—Peverelli, P. Searching for worm-eggs with the aid of cedar-oil preparations. Meded. dienst volksgez. Ned. Indie, 1928, 17: 569-72.—Quadflieg, L. Ein Beitrag zur Facesuntersuchung auf Parasiteneier. Deut. med. Wschr, 1909, 35: 2106.—Sarmento Magalhaes, J. Dos metodos de enriquecimento das fezes em ovohelmintoscopia. Impr. med, Rio, 1941, 17: No. 332, 40-8.—Schneider, A. Mistaking the Beeds of Vanilla planifolia for the ova of intestinal parasites. Merck Rep, 1915, 24: 87.—Scott, J. A, & Headlee, W. H. Studies in Egypt on the correction of helminth egg count data for the size and consistency of stools. Am. J. Hyg, 1938, 27: 176-95.—Shahmatov, A. P. Die Methode der Schleiment- nahme aus der Ampulla recti zur Untersuchung auf Wurmeier. Arch. Schiffs Tropenhyg, 1928, 32: 352-4.—Taylor, E. L. The diagnosis of helminthiasis by means of egg counts, with special reference to red-worm disease in horses. Vet. Rec, Lond, 1939, 51: 895-8.—Taylor, J. The examination of the faeces for ova of intestinal parasites. Ind. M. Gaz, 1911, 46: 134.—Tiprez, J., & Moulin, H. Comparaison des r£sultat9 fournis, dans la recherche des oeufs de parasites dans les selles, par r£colte unique ou par r^coltes multiples. C. rend. Soc. biol, 1928, 99: 231.—Torioji, T. Examination of fasces for eggs of intestinal parasites. Sei i kwai, 1910, 29: 500.—Whitlock, J. H. A practical dilution-egg-count procedure. J. Am. Vet. M. Ass, 1941, 98: 466-9.—Wolff, F. Beitrag zur Fiicesunter- Buchung auf Parasiteneier. Berl. klin. Wschr, 1913, 50: 301. ---- Pathogenicity. Azzolina, G. Intossicazione verminosa. Med. prat. Nap, 1928, 13: 233-6.—Bachman, G. W. Helminths as agents of disease: Trematodes; Cestodes; Nematodes. In Agents of Disease (Gay, F. P.) Springf, 1935, 1324-409.—Cameron, T. W. M. Comparative pathology of helminths. Vet. Rec, Lond, 1933, 13: 325-31.—Chandler, A. C. The pathogenic effects of helminthic infections. Ind. M. Gaz, 1926, 61: 157.—Faure & Marotel. Sur un mecanisme de Taction patho- g£ne chez quelques helminthes. Bull. Soc. sc. \6t. Lyon, 1902, 5: 142-8.—Feng, L. C. Studies on tissue lesions produced by helminths. Arch. Schiffs Tropenhyg, 1931, 35: 1-10.— Galli-Valerio, B. Recherches helminthologiques: infection experimentale des Cyclops du lac des quatre cantons avec les embryons du Dibothriocephalus latus; les migrations des ascarides dans l'organisme. Schweiz. med. Wschr, 1923, 53: 314-fl.—Larrousse, F. Parasites vermineux, cristaux fuchsino- pbiles acidor£sistants et reactions hyperplasiques. C. rend. Soc. biol, 1932, 109: 666-8.—Launoy, L. Pouvoir helmin- thologique et constitution chimique. Biol, mid., Par, 1938, 28: 349-84.—Strong, R. P. The role played by helminths in the production of tumors in man and animals. Internat. Clin, 1931, 4: 68-92, 4 pl. ---- Serology. See also Helminthosis, Immunology. Campbell, D. H. The immunological specificity of a poly- saccharide fraction from some common parasitic helminths. J. Parasit, Lancaster, 1937, 23: 348-53.—Eisenbrandt, L. L. Precipitin reactions of helminth extracts. Proc. Soc. Exp Biol, N. Y, 1936-37, 35: 322-5. ------ On the serological relationship of some helminths. Am. J. Hyg, 1938, 27: 117-41. ---- Toxin. Mandoul, R. Recherches recentes et opinions nouvelles sur la toxicite des helminthes. Ann. parasit. Par, 1939, 17: 187-92.—Meirelles, E. Toxinas verminosas. Tribuna med Rio, 1913, 19: 22; 101; 117—Mergasova, E. F. [Effect of helmintho-toxins on tissular protease of animals] Biull. eksp biol. med, 1939, 8: 499-501. Also Bull. biol. med. exp. URSS' 1939, 8: 478-80—Smorodintsev, I. A. [On the nature of helminthic toxins] Ter. arkh, 1936, 14: 846-9. HELMINTHIASIS. See Helminthosis. HELMINTHOCHORTON. See Sphaerococcus. HELMINTHOLOGY HELMINTHOLOGY. See also Helminthes; Helminthosis. Dobrova, M. I. [Work of the helminthological department of the Tropical Institute at Rostov-on-the-Don) Med. parazit Moskva, 1940, 9: 463.—Galli-Valerio, B. Observations hel- minthologiques. Schweiz. Arch. Tierh, 1935, 77: 420-8.__ Leiper, R. T. Department of helminthology. J. London School Trop. M, 1911, 1: 111; 1912, 2: 37. ------ Dis- cussion of the validity of certain generic names at present in use in medical helminthology. Arch. Schiffs Tropenhyg 1926, 30: 484-91.------Helminthology: a chapter in comparative medicine. Proc. R. Soc. M, Lond, 1933, 27- Sect. Comp. Med, 127-34. Also Vet. Rec, Lond, 1934, 14! 123-8.—Leon, N. Notices helminthologiqurs. Zbl. Bakt 1. Abt, 1915, 76: Orig, 519-22.—Lins de Almeida, J. Notes helminthologiques. C. rend. Soc. biol, 1935, 118: 285.— Monnig, H. O. Helminthological notes. Hep. Dir. Vet Educ. Pretoria, 1926, 11:-12: 221-8. -Neveu-Lemaire. Traits d'helminthologie m^dicale et v6t6rinaire. Bull. Acad vit. France, 1938, 11: 144-7.—Scott, J. A. Horizontes hel- mintol6gicos. Rev. san, Caracas, 1941, 6: 509-22.—Skyabin, K. I. [Helminthology and medicine] Mosk. med. J, 1923* 3: 1-6.—Travassos, L. Notas helminthologicas. Brasii med, 1922, 36: 256.—Van den Berghe, L. Une enqueue helminthologique k l'6cole professionnelle de la Kafubu (Ka- tanga) Ann. Soc. beige mid. trop, 1934, 14: 193-7. ---- Collections. Sandgrotjnd, J. H. Some parasitic worms in the helminthological collection of the Museum of Comparative Zoology, p.35-61. 8? Cambr., 1938. Daubney, R. The diagnosis of intestinal helminth infesta- tion (with notes on the collection and preservation of parasitic worms) Kenya East Afr. M. J, 1926, 3: 122-31.—Lent, H, & Teixeira de Freitas, J. F. Alguns helminthos da colleccSo de Pedro Severiano de Magalhaes. Mem. Inst. Oswaldo Cruz, 1937, 32: 305-9, pl.—Solomon, S. G. On a collection of parasitic worms from East Africa. J. Helminth, Lond, 1932, 10: 209.—Travassos, L. Algunas helminthos da colleccao do Instituto Bacteriologico de S. Paulo. Brasil med, 1917, 31: 99. ------ Helminthos da colleccao do Museu Paulista. Ibid, 121. ---- History. Isenberg, M. *Der Fortschritt der tropischen Helminthologie seit dem Kriege. 45p. 8? Berl., 1935. Briining, H. Helminthiasis, mit besonderer Beriicksichti- gung des Kindesalters (2. Sammelreferat; Literatur 1921) Mschr. Kinderh, 1922-23, 24: 331-45.—Chu, H. J, & Ch'iang, I. H. Extracts from some old Chinese medical books on worm infections. Nat. M. J, China, 1931, 17: 655-66.—Crdnicas; helmintiasis. Bol. Of. san. panamer, 1942, 21: 156-68 — Daubney, R. Some recent advances in medical helminthology. Kenya East Afr. M. J, 1926, 3: 33-45.—Hoeppli, R., & Ch'iang, I. H. Selections from old Chinese medical literature on various subjects of helminthological interest. Chin. M. J, 1940, 57: 373-87.—Hsu, H. F. Historical development, present status and future prospect of helminthology in China. Ibid, 68: 363-9.—Khalil. A century of helminthology in the Cairo Medical School. C. rend. Congr. internat. mid. trop. hyg, 1932, 1. Congr, 4: 3-25.—Leiper, R. T. Landmarks in medical helminthology. J. Helminth, Lond, 1929, 7: 101-18.— Maciel, H. A evolucao do estudo das helminthoses do homem, no Brasil. Brasil med, 1936, 50: 1035-7.—Peters, B. G. Some recent developments in helminthology. Proc. R. Soc. M, Lond, 1935-36, 29: 1074-84.—Skriabin, K. I, & Pod- volskaia, V. P. [Development of medical helminthology in Soviet Russia] Med. parazit, Moskva, 1937, 6: 843-64.— Thapar, G. S. Progress of helminthology in India. In Livr. Jub. Prof. Travassos, Rio, 1938, 459-66.—Vaskhnil & Skriabin, K. I. [The highest achievements of Soviet helminthological science] Priroda, Leningr, 1938, 27: 60-9.—Vevers, G. M. The progress of helminthology in the U. 8. S. R. Postgrad, M. J, Lond, 1942, 18: 11. ---- Manual. Baylis, H. A. A manual of helminthology, medical and veterinary. 303p. 8? Lond., 1929. Faust, E. C. Human helminthology; a manual for clinicians, sanitarians and medical zoologists. 616p. 8? Phila., 1929. Also 2. ed. 780p. 24cm. [1939] Heidegger, E. Wurmtafeln zum Bestimmen der wichtigsten Haustierparasiten. 121p. 8° Stuttg., 1937. Kranzfeld, A. M. [Parasitic worms in man] 120p. 8? Moskva, 1931. 4i HELMINTHOLOGY 463 HELMINTHOSIS Minale, S. I vermi intestinali dell'uomo. 143p. 8! Nap., 1936. Neveu-Lemaire, M. Trait6 d'helmmthologie medicale et veterinaire. 1514p. 8? Par., 1936. Sprehn, C. E. W. Lehrbuch der Helmintholo- gie; eine Naturgeschichte der in deutschen Saugetieren und Vogeln schmarotzenden Wurmer unter besonderer Berucksichtigung der Hel- minthen des Menschen, der Haustiere und wichtigsten Nutztiere. 998p. 8! Berl., 1932. Stiles, C. W., & Hassall, A. Key-catalogue of the worms reported for man. 196p. 8° Wash., 1926. . Szidat, L., & Wigand, R. Leitfaden der ein- heimischen Wurmkrankheitcn des Menschen. 212p. 8? Lpz., 1934. ---Methods. Brezzi, G. Ricerche e statistiche di elmintologia intestinale. Arch. ital. sc. med. col, 1928, 9: 743-74.—Godman, G. C, & Willey, C. H. Notes on embryonating eggs of Zygocotyle lunata and on their preparation for cytological study. J. Parasit, Lancaster, 1941, 27: No. 6, Suppl, 15.—Hoeppli, R, Feng, L. C, & Chu, H. J. Attempts to culture helminths of vertebrates in artificial media. Chin. M. J, 1938, Suppl. 2, 343-74.—Miretsky, O. I. [Floroglucine reaction in helmin- thological practice] Med. parazit, Moskva, 1940, 9: 452.— Morell, J. La investigacion de gusanos intestinales. Bol. farm, mil, Madr, 1931, 9: 289-94.—Nazmi, M. A modified loop for recovering helminth ova from stools prepared by Willis flotation method. J. Egypt. M. Ass, 1932, 15: 83—Podya- polskaia, W. P. [Methods in the organisation of medical helminthological expeditions] Med. parazit, Moskva, 1932, 1: 147-56.—Rukhadze & Blajin. On a new method for staining flukes and tapeworm segments as whole microscopical prepara- tions. J. Trop. M. Hyg, Lond, 1929, 32: 342.—Schmid, F. Beitrag zur Technik der helminthologischen Untersuchung. Zbl. Bakt, 1. Abt, 1935, 134: 150.—Schulz, R. E. S. [Present trend of experimental helminthology] Med. parazit, Moskva, 1933, 2: 201-11.—Smirnov, G. G. [Quantitative helmin- thological analysis] Vest, mikrob, 1929, 8: 63-78.—Toledo Artigas, P. de. Mounting of helminths and small arthropods; a new, simple and efficient method. Mem. Inst. Butantan, 1936, 10: 71-5, 4 pl.—Vasilkova, Z. G. [Methods of helmin- thological examination of water and soil] Gig. & zdorov, 1941, 6: 37-9.—Zschucke, J. Eine Kammer fiir die mikroskopische Zahlung von Helmintheneiern und -larven. Arch. Schiffs Tropenhyg, 1931, 35: 357-63. HELMINTHOSIS. See also Communicable diseases; Helminthes; Intestine, Parasites; also names of helminths as Ascaris; Cestoda; Enterobius; Nemathelminthes; Trematoda, &c; also Worms. Lipps, P. K. Why is the world sick? 136p. 20^cm. Bost. [1940] Bryce, L. W. Unbidden guests. Hygeia, Chic, 1940, 18: 28-30.—Escalier, A. L'helminthiase intestinale. Medecine, Par, 1926-27, 8: 787-92.—Garzon Cossa, G. Helmintiasis y protozoasis. Bol. Of. san. panamer, 1932, 11: 718-41.— Goldman, H. Ueber Helminthiasis. Wien. med. Wschr, 1932, 82: 1573.—Greenway, D. Consideraciones sobre diagn6stico, pronostico, tratamiento y profilaxis de la helmintiasis intestinal. Prensa med. argent, 1934-35, 21:-22: Suppl, 233-42 — Helmintiasis y protozoasis. Bol. Of. san. panamer, 1933, 12: 1126; 1935, 14: 131.—Hem&ndez Toledo, S. Helminthiasis. Rev. med, Puebla, 1934, 6: No. 47, 4-10.— Jerace, F. Le elmintiasi dell'uomo. Gior. med. prat, 1938, 20: 403-16.— Joyeux, C. Quelques donnees nouvelles sur les helminthiases. Bull, med. Par, 1938, 52: 796; 803.—Kaufmann, W. Ueber Wurmerkrankungen. Med. Klin, Berl, 1938, 34: 810 — Loeper. Los trastornos generales de ciertas helmintiasis intestinales. Dfa med, B. Air, 1931-32, 4: 545.—Londoiio, J. B. Parasitismo intestinal: verminosis. An. Acad. med. Medellin, 1932-33, 2: 743-50.—Madsen, H. [Helminths and helminthosis; a brief review] Bibl. laeger, 1941, 133: 113-45.— May, H. Ueber Wurmerkrankungen. Med. Khn, Berl, 1938, 34: 402.—Resumen grdfico de las helmintiasis humanas. Dia med, B. Air, 1941, 13: 1158-60.—Rousseau, A. Helminthiase. Bull. med. Quebec, 1922, 23: 1-5.—Schweitzer, A. Neuere Beitrage zur Biologie, Symptomatologie und Therapie der Wurmkrankheiten (Oxyuriasis und Askaridiasis) Wien. med. Wschr, 1936, 86: 1339-41.—Silvado, J. A proposito da verminose intestinal. Tribuna med, Rio, 1916, 22: 183-91. Also Brasil. med, 1917, 31: 20.—Van Slype, W. Contribution k l'etude des helminthiases intestinales. Ann. Soc. beige med. trop, 1932, 12: 569; 1933, 13: 85.—Wheeler, C. M. Helminthic infections. Southwest. M, 1940, 24: 195-9.— Wilcocks, C. Helminthiasis. Trop. Dis. Bull, Lond, 1941, 38: 425; passim. ---- Allergy [and anaphylaxis] See also Allergy, parasitic; Dermatosis, para- sitic; Eczema, &c. Herber, A. *Haufigkeit und Formenkreis von Hauterscheinungen bei gleichzeitiger Wurm- erkrankung [Breslau] 35p. 21cm. Ohlau, 1937. Cappelli, E. Rapporti fra elmintiasi e dermatosi. Dermo- sifilografo, 1937, 12: 508-11. ------ Hauterscheinungen als Ausdrucksformen von Darmplage durch Helminthen. Derm Wschr, 1941, 112: 17.—Ciculesco-Mayromati, M. Un cas d'anaphylaxie vermineuse transmise de I'homme au cobaye. C. rend. Soc. biol, 1927, 97: 995-7.—Cieszynski, F. X. Les reactions cutan^es helminthiasiques chez les enfants. Arch. m<5d. enf, 1928, 31: 341-8. Also Mschr. Kinderh, 1928, 39: 64-71.—Colangeli, L. Le manifestazioni tossi-anafilattiche nell'elmintiasi. Prat, pediat, Milano, 1939, 17: 40-8.— Coventry, F. A, & Taliaferro, W. H. Hypersensitiveness to helminth proteins; cutaneous tests with proteins of ascaris, hookworm and trichurls in Honduras. J. Prevent. M, 1928, 2: 273-88.—De Gaetani, G. F. I fenomeni anafilattici da elminti; rassegna sintetica. Arch. ital. med. sper, 1939, 4: 891-926.— FUlleborn, F. Demonstration uber Kutanreaktion bei Helmin- thenaffektionen. Arch. Schiffs Tropenhyg, 1926, 30: Beih. 1, 86-8. ------ & Kikuth, W. Ueber Cutanreaktionen bei Helmintheninfektionen. Ibid, 1929, 33: Beih. 3, 168-71.— Gorchakov, I. A. [Helminthic invasion as etiological moment of eczema symptoms in children] Pediatria, Moskva, 1941, No. 6, 61.—Mello, U. Recherches sur l'anaphylaxie vermineuse. Congr. internat. path, comp, 1914, 2. Congr, 612-6.— Moraes, J., jr. Nota sobre choque anaphylactico in vitro com extractos de helminthos. Brasil med, 1932, 46: 638.—Morenas & Gallouin. Eosinophilic vermineuse et anaphylaxie. Lyon med, 1926, 138: 151-7.—Nicoll, W. The relation of parasitic worms to affections of the skin. Med. Press & Circ, Lond, 1927, n. ser, 123: 191-3.—Oliveira Lima, A. Alergia em helmintologia; sobre o valor dos testes cutaneos para o diag- nostico das helmintiasis. Brasil med, 1941, 55: 845-8.— Paul ian, D. E. L'anaphylaxie comme cause des troubles nerveux produits par les vers intestinaux. Rev. neur. Par, 1914, 22: 440.—Rackemann, F. M, & Stevens, A. H. Skin tests to extracts of echinococcus and ascaris. J. Immun, Bait, 1927, 13: 389-94.—Schultz, R. E, & Shikhobalova, N. P. [Allergic, cutaneous reactions in helminthiasis] Med. parazit, Moskva, 1937, 6: 116-33.—Vaz, Z. Relacoes entre helmintos e lesoes cutaneas no homem. An. paul. med. cir, 1941, 42: 433-5. ---- Associated diseases. Bagnasco, S. L'elmintiasi fra i ricoverati nell'Ospedale psichiatrico di Genova (Quarto) Igiene mod, 1935, 28: 209- 15.—Cade, Morenas & Jeannin. De l'influence des toxines vermineuses sur Involution de la tuberculose experimentale. J. physiol. path, gen, 1928, 26: 250-5.—Cochaux, I. Helmin- thiases assockies aux avitaminoses; le nzadi ou lupusu des indigenes du Kasai. Ann. Soc. beige med. trop, 1937, 17: 491-500.—Gupta, P. Worms not removed in diarrhoea of cholera. Ind. J. M, 1922-23, 3: 1.—Kokin, M. K. [Helminthic invasion in the mentally sick] Nevropat. psikhiat, 1936, 5: 1802-10.—Maplestone, P. A, & Bhaduri, V. N. Cholera and intestinal helminths. Ind. M. Gaz, 1936, 71: 449.—Martino, L. Morbillo ed elmintiasi. Studium, Nap, 1926, 16: 420 — Poisson, H. Helminthiases et tuberculose. Bull. Soc. path. exot. Par, 1936, 29: 931-3. ---- Casuistics. Dillenseger. Un cas d'helminthiase inestinale. Bull. Soc. radiol. med. France, 1929, 17: 118.—Glock, R. Ueber einen bemerkenswerten Fall von Helminthiasis. Med. Klin, Berl, 1921, 17: 938.—Maxwell, J. L. Report of faecal examination of 1,000 cases male and 50 cases female. China M. J, 1908, 22: 217-24.—Mirgtsky, O. J. [Three cases from the Smolensk Helminthological Dispensary] Med. parazit, Moskva, 1936, 5. sio —Pacelli, C. Sopra un caso di elmintiasi tardivamente rivelatasi. Med. prat. Nap, 1928, 13: 267-9—Pevtsov, B. E. [Cases of helminthiasis] Khirurgia, Mosvka, 1937, No. 6, 162. ---- Complication. See also Anemia; Appendicitis; Epilepsy, &c. Ackert, J. E., & Otto, G. F. Helminthiasis and the thyroid -land. Am. J. Trop. M, 1927, 7: 339-47— Banerji, B. P. A case of typho-lumbricosis. Ind. M. Gaz, 1927, 62: 146.— Barbaro, G. Su di un caso di elmintiasi con ittero emolitico splenomegalico e suoi rapporti con la splenomegaha emohtica costituzionale. Gazz. osp, 1931, 53: 164-9—Chienci, A. Accessi convulsivi ed elmintiasi intestinale. Gior. clin. med., 1931 12: 851-5.—Di Pirro, V. Di alcune comphcazioni eccez'ionaii dell'elmintiasi. Arch. ital. sc. med. col, 1932, 13: 353__Figueiredo, J. de. Elmintoses e suas consequencias. Rev med. Bahia, 1940, 8: 337-44. Also Impr. med, Rio, 1941, 17* 47-9 —Folinea, R. Intorno un caso di- corea congiunto a notabile'elmintiasi. Ann. clin. Osp. incurab. Nap, 1839, 5: HO-4 —Gordon, R. M. The effect of ancylostome, ascaris, and t'richuris infections on the health of *he West African native. Ann. Trop. M. Parasit., Liverp., 1925-26, 19: 429- HELMINTHOSIS 464 HELMINTHOSIS 60, pl.—(.uillain & Gardin. Accidents mcningca de l'helmin- thiase. Rev. path, comp. Par, 1922, 22: 138.—Hautefeuille, J. M^ningite vermineuse. Ann. parasit. Par, 1935, 13: 21-7. Also Clinique, Par, 1936, 31: 271-3.—Lenhartz, H. Ueber Wurmaniimie. Zbl. inn. Med, 1927, 48: 954.—Liubimov, V. I. [Anemic states in helminthous affections] Med. parazit, Moskva, 1936, 5: 687-91.—Lombari, L. Tre casi di pseudo- meningite da elminti. Pensiero med, 1925, 14: 183.—Mandoul, A. H. A propos de Taction de quelques helminthes sur revolu- tion de la tuberculose. Ann. parasit. Par, 1931, 9: 323.— Oselladore, G. Ricerche sulla infestazione verminosa dell'ap- pendice cecale e suoi rapporti con 1'appendicite. Arch. ital. mal. app. diger, 1931-32, 1: 114-27.—Rokhkinda, I. M. [Carcinoid tumors of vermicular origin] Vest, khir, 1922, 2: pt 6, 171-8.—Salah, M. Studies on anaemia in Egypt; treat- ment and mechanism of helminthic anaemia. J. Egypt. M. Ass, 1935, 18: 455-72.—Salazar de Souza, J. Sur un cas de parapl^gie helminthique. Arch. med. enf, 1934, 37: 479-81.— Sokolov, M. L [On helminthic obstruction] Khirurgia, Moskva, 1938, No. 5, 137.—Tereza, S. I. [Helminthiasis as a factor of interrupted pregnancy and sterility in mammals] Tr. Konf. med. biol. (1936) Kiev, 1937, 222-9. ---- Control, and prevention. Izzet Bey, I. *La prophylaxie des hel- minthiases en Egypte. 63p. 8? Par., 1925. Bloch, A. Eine Wurm-EnquSte. Schweiz. med. Wschr, 1933, 63: 594-7.—Braun-Stappenbeck, M. Ein Beitrag zur Verbreitung der Wurmerkrankungen und deren Verhiitung. Fortsch. Med, 1941, 59: 53-5.—Briining, H. Eingeweide- wiirmer und ihre Bekampfung. Deut. med. Wschr, 1934, 60: 425-31.—Calvo Fonseca, R. Organizaci6n de una campafia de deshelmintizaci6n en la Repflblica. Rev. med. cir. Habana, 1941, 46: 8-28.—Cort, W. W. Research on helminth diseases and public health progress. Am. J. Trop. M, 1940, 20: 183- 98.—Fonseca, O. da, filho. Verminoses, sua prophylaxia. Rev. med. cir. Brasil, 1931, 39: 105-31.—Forostovskaia, L. G. [On the control of helminthic invasion in nursery schools and schools) Sovet. pediat, 1935, No. 12, 101-5.—Hage. Soil und kann eine Verwurmung von Schulkindern bekampft werden? [ausgefiihrt an einem Beispiel aus Thiiringen] Miinch. med. Wschr, 1923, 70: 85-7.—Helminthiasis (The) problem. Merck Rep, 1939, 48: No. 4, 23—Joyeux, C. La prophylaxie des bilharzioses et des distomatoses d'aprea les travaux recents. Presse mid., 1921, 29: annexe, 568. ------ La prophylaxie des helminthiases. Rev. hyg. Par.. 1927, 49: 499-515— Kamalov, N. G. [Campaign against helminthosis in Georgia] Med. parazit, Moskva, 1937 6: 266-8— Khalil, M. The pail closet as an efficient means of controlling human helminth infection as observed in Tura Prison, Egypt, with a discussion on the source of ascaris infection. Ann. Trop. M. Parasit, Liverp, 1931-32, 25: 35-62, 4 pl.—Khoruzhenko, P. F., & Grevezirska, M. V. [Examination and dehelminthization of school children] Profil. med, Kharkov, 1931, 10: 14-8.— Lentze, F. A. Ueber die Verbreitung von Spul- und Maden- wiirmern und iiber die Massnahmen zu ihrer Bekampfung vom Standpunkte der offentlichen Gesundheitspflege. Veroff. Medverwalt, 1932, 37: 1-79.—Liebermann, L. von, & Freund, J. War Fleisch oder Wurst bis zurTotungstemperatur von Parasiten erhitzt? Zschr. Hyg, 1922-23, 97: 315-21.—Lipinski, W. [Study of influence of intestinal parasites on human or- ganism and of prevention of parasitism (ascaridiasis, tricho- cephaliasis or oxyuriasis)] Polska gaz. lek, 1928, 7: 449-57.— Lisboa, I. Como organizar uma campanha eficiente para o combate & opilacao. Arq. saude pub, Belo Horiz, 1933, 1: 43-7.—Oda, M. On the human parasite eggs attached to the vegetables and the effectiveness of water rinsing as a means of eliminating them. J. Chosen M. Ass, 1927, No. 73, 3.— Scott, J. A., & Barlow, C. H. Limitations to the control of helminth parasites in Egypt by means of treatment and sanita- tion. Am. J. Hyg, 1938, 27: 619-48. Also repr.—Serbinov, P. J. [Prophylaxis of helminthiasis] Profil. med, Kharkov, 1928, 7: No. 8, 17-31.—Skriabin, K. I. [Helminthologic campaign in the lower Volga region] Trop. med. vet, Moskva, 1931, 9: 21-7. ------ [Helminthologic campaign in the Nizhegorod region] Ibid, 75-9. ------ [Organization against helminthous affections in Soviet Russia] Med. parazit Moskva, 1936, 5: 647-56.—Vasilkova, Z. G. [On dehel- minthization of sewage water by methods of intensive puri- fication] Ibid, 657-74. ------ [Significance of composting impurities and garbage for dehelminthization] Ibid, 1938, 7: 898-906. ------ [Role of medical centers in control of helminthosis] Sovet. med., 1941, 5: No. 7, 35. ---- Diagnosis. See also Feces, Examination; Helminthes, Ovum: Counting. Arancio, V. Sulla frequenza dell'elmintiasi e su di un metodo per isvelaria coll'analisi delle urine (ricerche ed osser- vazioni personali) Med. prat. Nap, 1926, 11: 335-8.— Bonne, C. [Intestinal helminthiasis; identification of the worm, with description of several new cases] Geneesk. tschr Ned. Indie, 1937, 77: 618-22—Brailsibrd, J. F. The X-ray diagnosis of animal parasites (Helminthes) in man. Proc R. Soc. M., Lond, 1925-26, 19: Sect. Electro-Ther., 41-52.— Braun, H. Zur Diagnostik der Wurmerkrankungen. Hippo- krates, Stuttg, 1941, 12: 518-20.—Dcrrien, E. Porphyrinua et vers parasites. Crend.Acad.se, 1927, 184: 480.—Diaj. nosis of intestinal worms. Seminar, Phila, 1939, 1: No. 2 11-4.—Dournes. Helminthiase intestinale decouverte par les rayons X. Arch, electr. mdd, 1931, 39: 73.—Kfendiev M. E. [Vidal's reaction in helminthiasis] Klin, med, Moskva' 1937, 15: 810-2.—Faust, K. C, Sawitz, W. [et al.] Compara- tive efficiency of various technics for the diagnosis of protozoa and helminths in feces. J. Parasit, Lancaster, 1939, 25: 241-62.—Frcinkman, E. Z. [Comparative value of coprologio examinations for helminthiasis] Odess. med. J, 1930, 5: 147-54. —Hilmy, I. S. The microscopic examination of faeces for helminthic infection. J. Egypt. M. Ass, 1935, 18: 39-47.—Khaskina-Munder, G. [Coli-index in children with helminthiasis] J. mikrob, Moskva, 1939, No. 6, 40-5.— Knotz, I. Zur Erkennung der Wurmkrankheit. Miinch. med. Wschr, 1933, 80: 1947.—Lamarque. Helminthiase intestinale decouverte par les rayons X. Arch, electr. mid., 1930, 38: 241-4.—Lane, C. Diagnosis of helminthic infections: a 12 year survey. Trop. Dis. Bull, Lond, 1933, 30: 503-16.— McLean, R. C. Plant hairs as pseudo-parasites. Lancot Lond, 1916, 2: 1100-2.—Maplestone, P. A. The laboratory diagnosis and the treatment of helminth infections. Ind.M. Gaz, 1934, 69: 266-73, 2 pl.—Nazmi, M. The microscopical diagnosis of helminth infection in Egypt. J. Egypt. M. Abs, 1931, 14: 412-8.—Paretskaia, M. S. [Quantitative diagnosis of helminthic invasion] Med. parazit, Moskva, 1940, 9: 453-7.—Parreiras, D. Valor do exame microscopico na luta contra as verminoses. Fol. med, Rio, 1923, 4: 59.—Scaduto, P. La reazione di Ydfimov nella diagnosi delle elmintiasi. Arch. ital. sc. med. col., 1933, 14: 564-8.—Schwennicke, H. Hel- minthiasis oder Hernia epigastrica? Miinch. med. Wschr., 1934, 81: 1048.—Shukhat, I. A. [Methods of examination for helminthiasis] Odess. med. J, 1930, 5: 119-46.—Statirova, N. A., & Vassilkova, Z. G. [Value of the helmintho-ovoscopio examination of rectal mucus] Trop. med. vet, Moskva, 1931, 9: 79-82.—Tarasov, V. A. [Diagnosis of helminthosis] Vrach. gaz, 1927, 31: 489-93.—Taylor, E. L. Some fallacies in the diagnosis of helminthic disease. Proc. R. Soc. M, Lond, 1934- 35, 28: 1002-4.—Thomson, J. G. Pseudoparasites in the faeces of man. Ibid, 1925-26, 19: Sect. Trop. Dis. Parasit, 14-8.—Willis, C. A. It may be helminths. North Carolina M. J, 1940, 1: 613-5. ---- Epidemiology. Caldwell, F. C, Caldwell, E. L., & Davis, G. E. Some aspects of the epidemiology of infestation with trichuris and ascaris as revealed in a study at the hospitals for the insane and the home for mentally defective children in the State of Alabama. Am. J. Hyg, 1930, 11: 619-51.—Cort, W. W., Schapiro, L., & Stoll, N. R. A study of reinfection after treat- ment with hookworm and ascaris in 2 villages in Panama. Ibid, 1929, 10: 614-25.—Cort, W. W., Schapiro, L. [et al. A study of the influence of the rainy season on the level oi helminth infestations in a Panama village. Ibid, 626-34.— Headlee, W. H. Epidemiological studies of helminth infections in an Egyptian village; soil pollution and soil infestation. Ibid, 1933, 18: 695-711. Also repr. ------ Studies on infections of human parasitic worms under institutional conditions. J. Lab. Clin. M, 1934-35, 20: 1069-77.—Horsfall, M. W. Notes on the spread, in 1 year, of helminths from in- fected to uninfected poultry yards. Proc. Helminth. Soc. Washington, 1936, 3: 66.—Joyeux. Epidemiologic, prophy- laxie et therapeutique des helminthiases d'aprea les travaux recents. Biol, med. Par, 1924, 14: 209-39.—Pavlovsky, E. N. [Epidemiology of helminthiasis] Vest, mikrob, 1926, 5: 125-32.— Pessoa, S. B., & Lucena, D. Sobre a disseminacao de helminthoses nos habitantes de uma localidade saneada. Rev. biol, S. Paulo, 1938-39, 9: 17-38. Also Arq. hig, S. Paulo, 1941, 6: No. 11, 77-97.—Schapiro, L., & Cort, W. W. A study of the relation of the dry season to the level of hel- minth infestation in a Panama village. Am. J. Hyg, 1930, 12: 699-708. Also repr.—Schweitzer, A. [Epidemiology and therapy of intestinal worms] Gy6gy£szat, 1937, 77: 553-5.— Skriabin, K. I., & Schultz, R. S. [Introduction into practical study of helminthic parasites; concept of helminthocestoidal index] Profil. med, Kharkov, 1927, 6: 21-8.—Spindler, L. A. The relation of moisture to the distribution of human Trichuris and Ascaris. Am. J. Hyg, 1929, 10: 476-96.—Whitaker, P. F. The frequency and clinical manifestations of intestinal worms. Ann. Int. M., 1930-31, 4: 1212-6. ---- Geography. Cotjrbil, R. *Essai de repartition geo- graphique des helminthiases humaines dans l'Empire colonial francais. 116p. 8? Par., 1929. Joyeux. Les helminthiases intestinales dans les colonies franchises; prophylaxie et traitement d'aprea lea travaux recents. Rev. med. hyg. trop. Par, 1923, 15: 193-5 — Leger, M. Helminthiase intestinale et bilharziose americaine k la Martinique: comparaison des indices parasitaires avec ceux de la Guadeloupe et de la Guyane francaise. Gaz. sc. med. Bordeaux, 1922, 48: 230-3.—Talice, R. V. Sobre para- sitologia nacional; helmintiasis intestinales nacionales. Bol. Cons. nac. hig, Montev, 1926, 21: 432-43.—Terskikh, V. [Helminthocenotio index] Med. parazit., Moskva, 1932, HELMINTHOSIS 465 HELMINTHOSIS S4_r.__Voizard. A propos de l'helminthiase chez les indigenes. BuU" Soc med. mil fr, 1939, 33: 251-6.-Webb, J. L. The helminths of the intestinal canal of man in Mauritius; and a first record of Trichostrongylus axei locally. Parasitology, Lond, 1937, 29: 469-76. .--- Geography: Africa. Ali, A. *Ankylostomiasis und Schistoso- miasis' in Aegypten. 32p. 8? Berl., 1925. Mehaotjed, T. H. *Les helminthiases hu- maines et leur frequence en Tunisie. 126p. 8°. Par., 1938. Advier. Les helminthiases chez le Malgache en Emyrne. Bull. Soc. path, exot. Par, 1929, 22: 390-3.—Carman, J. A. Observations on the incidence of helminthic infestations in natives of Kenya, with special reference to tfeniasis, its effect on nutrition and its treatment with carbon tetrachloride. J. Trop. M. Hyg, Lond, 1929, 32: 321-8.—Ciampolillo, P, & Sollini, A. Entente acuta con elmintiasi in Tripolitania. Arch. ital. sc. med. col, 1938, 19: 399-405.— Commes, C. L'eau du Niger et l'helminthiase intestinale. Bull. Soc. path, exot. Par, 1917, 10: 730.—Daubney, R, & Carman, J. A. Helminthic infestations of natives in the Kenya Highlands. Parasitology, Lond, 1928, 20: 185-206.—DeMeillon, B., & Holland, E. Helminthological notes from Zululand. S. Afr. M. J, 1939, 13: 798-802. Also repr.—Donatien, A. Enzootiealg£rienned'hel- minthiase nodulaire intestinale. Arch. Inst. Pasteur Afrique Nord 1921,1:86-8.—Easman, M. C. F. Helminthiasis in the Sierra Leone Protectorate. J. Trop. M. Hyg, Lond, 1924, 27: 305-7 —Fisk, G. H. Helminthiasis in Lagos, Nigeria. Tr. R. Soc. Trop. M. Hyg, Lond, 1938-39, 32: 645-52—Haddad, E. Bioiogie syst6matique et thdrapeutique de l'infestation helmin- thiasique au Kwango. Ann. Soc. beige mid. trop, 1939, 19: 539-44.—Helminthiases. In Notice Inst. Pasteur Algerie, 1934, 1: 191-4-—Jadin, J, & Delperdange, G. Contribution k l'fitude de l'helminthiase et de la parasitologic de l'Equateur. Ann. Soc. beige m«§d. trop, 1939, 19: 547-56.—Joyeux, C. Recherches sur la faune helminthologique alg^rienne (cestodes et trematodes) Arch. Inst. Pasteur Algerie, 1927, 5: 509-28. _____ & Baer, J. G. Note d'helminthologie tunisienne. Arch. Inst. Pasteur Tunis, 1928, 17: 347-9.—Joyeux, C, & Foley, H. Les helminthes de M^riones shawi shawi Rozet dans le nord de I'AlgSrie. Bull. Soc. zool. France, 1930, 55: 353-74.— Lamoureux, A. Frequence du parasitisme intestinal par Ascaris lumbricoides et par Tricocephalus trichiurus chez les habitants de la Grande Comore. Bull. Soc. path, exot. Par, 1913, 6: 455.—Leger, M, & Pringault, E. Helminthiase intestinale et bilharziose k Schistosomum mansoni k Madagas- car. Ibid, 1921, 14: 247-53.—Liodt. Contribution k l'etude de l'helminthiase intestinale en A. E. F.; la repartition du parasitisme chez les travailleurs du Congo-Oc6an et la cure de dSparasitisation par le t^trachlorure de carbone. Ibid, 1927, 20: 743-8.—Moise, R. Osservazioni sulle elmintiasi d'interesse epidemiologico in Somalia, 1932-37. Ann. med. nav, Roma, 1938, 44: 444-51.—Philip, C. R. A note on helminthic infec- tions'among some coast natives. KenyaEast Afr. M. J, 1927-28, 4- 207-10 —Rameses Girges. Helminthic dyspepsia in Egypt. J. Egypt. M. Ass, 1934, 17: 208-18.—Raynal, J. Helmin- thiases intestinales chez le Malgache. Bull. Soc. path, exot. Par, 1928, 21: 868-75.—Schwetz, J, & Baumann, H. Ob- servations helminthologiques sur les noirs de 1'age scolaire dans l'agglomeration de Stanleyville (Congo Beige) Ann. Soc. beige med. trop, 1929, 9: 307-17.—Veneroni, C. Note di elmmto- logia medica nella Somalia italiana. Arch. ital. sc. med. col, 1927, 8: 26-8. --- Geography: Asia, and Australia. Hoeppli, R., Hsu, H, F., & Wu, H. W. Hel- minthologische Beitrage aus Fukien und Che- kiang. 44p. 8? Lpz., 1929. Anandan Nambiar, T. V. Some observations on the preva- lence of helminth infection among the prisoners admitted in the central jail, Myingyan. Ind. M. Gaz, 1917, 52: 43b-9 — Ananian, S. A., & Kasarian, A. D. [Helminthological fauna among the inhabitants of the Etchmiadzin region (Armenia) 1 Russ. J. trop. med, 1929, 7: 598-603— Bellama, R. Intes- tinal worms in Syria and Lebanon; with special reference to Ancylostoma duodenale; analysis of 1,000 stools examinations. C. rend. Congr. internat. med. trop, 1932, 1. Congr, 4: 301- 5—Boulenger, C. L. Intestinal helminths m Indians in Mesopotamia. Parasitology, Lond, 1920-21, 12: 95-7. Chandler, A. C. The epidemiology of hookworm and other helminth infections on Assam tea estates. Ind. J. M. Kes, 1925-26, 13: 407-26, ch. ------ The prevalence and epi- demiology of hookworm and other helminthic infections in India: Eastern Bengal. Ibid, 1926-27 14: 195-218. —-— Assam and the Hill areas of Eastern Bengal. Ibid, 481-93, 2 ch. ------ The prevalence and epidemiology of hookworm and other helminthic infections in India: Burma. Ibid 733- 44, 2 ch, map. ------ Bihar and Orissa. Ibid, 745-59, 3 ch. map ------ United Provinces of Agra and Oudi. Ibid, 761-73, 4 ch, 2 maps. ------ The prevalence and epi- demiology of hookworm and other helminthic infections in India; general summary and conclusions. Ibid, 1927-28, ii>. 695-743, 3 maps.—Heine, J. Ueber intestinale Wurmin- fektionen bei Chinesen und in Shanghai lebenden Europaern. Tungchi med. Mschr, 1929-30, 5: 138-50.—Heydon, G. M, & Green, A. K. Some worm infestations of man in Australia. Med. J. Australia, 1931, 1: 619-28.—Hsu, H. F. Check list of parasitic helminths of animals and man in China. Chin. M. J, 1936, Suppl. 1, 457-73.—Joyeux, C. Travaux recents sur quelques helminthiases de Chine. Presse mid., 1924, 32: (annexe) 1971-3.—Kalantarian, E. W. Zur Kenntnis der Helminthenfauna der Kinder Armeniens nach den Ergebnissen der helminthenovoskopischen Untersuchungen. Arch. Schiffs Tropenhyg, 1926, 30: 76-86.—Kigler, I. J. Helminthic infection in Jerusalem. ' Tr. R. Soc. Trop. M. Hyg, Lond, 1923-24, 17: 46-8—Komiya, Y, Kawana, K., & Tao, S. In- vestigations into helminthiasis among Japanese pupils in Shanghai. Tr. Far East. Ass. Trop. M, 1934, 9. Congr, 1: 611-7.—Kovaleva, A. V. Helminth fauna in the huts of the miners of Shurab, Northern Tadzhikistan. Med. parazit, Moskva, 1939, 8: No. 5, 96.—Labernadie, V. G. F. Documents statistiques sur les helminthiases k Pondichery. Tr. Far East. Ass. Trop. M, 1927, 7. Congr, 3: 198.—Li, K. H. Incidence of parasitic helminths in Soochow; a preliminary report. Nat. M. J. China, 1923-24, 10: 7-19.—Manila, S, & Tsubouchi, J. The results of the examinations for the eggs of intestinal parasites among the whole class of the cruiser Akitsushima. Sei i kwai, 1910, 29: No. 5 [May]—Nauck, E. G., & Shan, Y. Zur Frage der Verbreitung von Wurmparasiten in Mittel- China. Arch. Schiffs Tropenhyg, 1926, 30: 503-10.—Nogusa, G, & Hotta, K. Ueber tierische Parasiteneier im Kot der Volksschuler in Hikamigun, Hyogo-ken. Mitt. Med. Ges. Osaka, 1919, 18: No. 10.—Plavtov, K. A. [Helminthosis in the children's orphanage of the American Committee in Armenia] Russ. J. trop. med, 1926, 13-6.—Russell, P. F. Racial and age group incidence of common intestinal helminths in the Straits Settlements. Malay. M. J, 1934, 9: 17-22. Also repr.—Schuurmans Stekhoven, J. H., jr [Intestinal . worms on Terschelling] Ned. tschr. geneesk, 1931, 75: 859- 73.—Sharma, A. N. Helminthic infections in Shillong. Ind. M. Gaz, 1930, 65: 200-3.—Watt, J. Y. C. Incidence of hel- minthic parasites with special reference to the epidemiology of Fasciolopsiasis buski in Shiaoshan, Chekiang, 1934-35. Chin. M. J, 1937, 51: 77-84.—Yenikomshian, H. A., & Berberian, D. A. The occurrence and distribution of human helmin- thiasis in Syria and the Lebanon, with case reports of Dicro- celium dendriticum and Hymenolepis nana infestations. Tr. R. Soc. Trop. M. Hyg, Lond, 1934, 27: 425-35, pl. ---- Geography: Europe. Hillenbrand, F. *Eingeweidewiirmer bei Kindern in Rostock. 32p. 8? Rostock, 1935. Klotz-Spritzmann, R. *Ueber die Haufigkeit der Darmparasiten bei Kindern in Zurich und Umgebung. 18p. 8? Ziir., 1908. Theodor, E. [E.] *Ein weiterer Beitrag zur Kenntnis der Verbreitung menschlicher Helmin- theninfektionen in Ostpreussen; Beobachtungen an 1330 Insassen der Medizin, Universitatsklinik und der Kinderklinik. 19p. 8? Konigsb., 1934. Bogoiavlensky, N, & Demidova, A. [Sanitary tests for helminth fauna of 100 toilets and of their users in Kazach town] Profil. med, Kharkov, 1927, 6: No. 11, 27-30—Briining, H. Zur Frage der Verwurmung mecklenburgischer Kinder. Arch. Kinderh, 1934-35, 104: 170-3.—Buonomini, G. Diffusione dell'elmintiasi in alcuni centri della campania. Boll. Soc. ital. biol. sper, 1938, 13: 796-9.—Cipriani, P. F. Ricerche di elmintologia intestinale nei Comune di Argenta. Arch. ital. sc med. col, 1929, 10: 262-7.—Denecke, K. Der Befall mit menschlichen Darmhelminthen auf der Elbinsel Finkenwarder und seine Ursachen. Arch. Hyg, Munch, 1936-37, 117: 332-62.—Dubrowinski, S. B., Jranzfeld, A. M. [et al.] Ueber die Verbreitung der parasitischen Wiirmer bei verschiedenen Bevolkerungsgruppen in Moskau und die Wege der medizini- schen Helminthologie. Zbl. Bakt, 1. Abt, 1929, 112: 481-96, tab__Frick'e, W. Vergleichende Wurmeier-Untersuchungen m Ma'zedonien. Deut. med. Wschr, 1917, 43: 845-7.—Ganago, F M., & Mednikov, B. I. [Helminthiasis in childhood; data from the helminthological investigation of the child population of the city of Petripavl'ovsk in Kazakhstan] Pediatria, Moskva, 1938 No 3, 73-80.—Gerstein, O. S. [Helminthologic examina- tion 'of children in Kazan; hemoglobin of the blood and weight of body before and after dehelminthization] Trop. med. vet, Moskva, 1931, 9: 32-8—Ginsburg, E. D. [Helminthosis among the children in Baku] Ibid, 126.—Giovanardi, A, & Mondolfo, U. L'elmintiasi in alcuni centri rurah della Ilomagna. Gior. batt. immun, 1934, 12: 1121-60.—Gromashevsky, L. V. fResults of the helminthologic work in Odessa] Odess. med. J, 1930 5- 5-22 ------ [Helminthiasis among children in Odessa]' Ibid ,' 23-44—Kandelaki, S. P, & Kamalov, N. G. [Helminthic fauna of the population of Georgia] Med parazit, Moskva 1937 6: 459-73.—Kasakova & Tolstopiat [Spread of parasitic worms among the inhabitants of Mozdok of the Tersk region (Russia)] Trop. med. vet,. Moskva, 1930, 8: 27 — Kostic D J. [Protozoal and helminthological investigations in school children (in Brestovik)] Glasnik Centr. hyg zav, Beoarad 1940 23: 353-8.—Kremer, B. I. [Helminthologic examination of Tartar children of Bakhchi-Sarai and Baidar 227475—vol. 7, 4th seej.es- -30 HELMINTHOSIS 466 HELMINTHOSIS valley (Crimea)] Trop. med. vet, Moskva, 1931, 9: 462.— Kushnir, E. D. [Helminthiasis among the children of the first children's city in Odessa] Odess. med. J, 1930, 5: 45-52.— Mastio. ('. L'elmintiasi in alcuni centri rurali della Sardegna. Atti >(>r. bc. med. natur. Cagliari, 1935, 37:442-51—Nitzulesco, V, 6l Nitzulesco, G. Contributions a, l'etude de l'helminthiase intestinale dans la region de Jassy. Bull. Acad. mid. Roumanie, 1930, 4: 100-3.—Paes, I. Sur la frequence des vers intestinaux chez les enfants de Lisbonne. Arq. Inst. bact. Camara Pestana, Lisb, 1918, 5: 17-27.— Perperez y Palau, F. Contribuci6n al estudio de las helmintiasis end£micas de la vega baja del Segura, San Fulbenico (Alicante) Rev. san. hig. pub, Madr, 1932, 7: 377-92.—Ratner, G. B. [Helminth fauna of the popula- tion of Zhitomir] Med parazit, Moskva, 1939, 8: 247.— Sciacchitano, I. Contributo alia conoscenza dell'elmintologia modenese. Arch. zool. ital, 1931, 15: pt 2, 245-52.—Shcha- Etynyi, N. M. [Helminthosis among school children of the Kanavino working class section] Trop. med. vet, Moskva, 1931, 9: 120-5.—Shukhat, I. A. [Helminthosis among workers in the Odessa irrigation fields] Gig. bezopas. pat. truda, 1930, 8: 53-6.—Skrjabin, K. I, Schulz, R. E. [et al.] Ergebnisse der Expedition zur Erforschung der Helminthosen der Kohlen- grubenarbeiter der Donjetzhohenkette. Zbl. Bakt, 1. Abt, 1929, 112: 454-8.—Strom, J. K. Helminthiasis among the northern and eastern USSR; study of the Institute for peoples of the North] In Parasites (Pavlovsky, E.) Moskva, 1935, 334-47.—Virdis, F, & De Lellis, V. Ancliilostomiasi ed elmintiasi in Provincia di Vercelli. Igiene mod, 1939, 32: 323-37.—Vogel, H. Helminthologische Beobachtungen in Ostpreussen, insbesondere iiber Dibothriocephalus latus und Opisthorchis felineus. Deut. med. Wschr, 1929, 55: 1631-3.— Vo-Van, C. Les helminthiases dans la population infantile de la region provencale. Marseille mid., 1934 71: 578-82.— Also Bull. Soc. path, exot. Par, 1935, 28: 829-32. Waisman, R. L. [Helminthiasis among workers in slaughter houses in Odessa] Odess. med. J, 1930, 5: 65-72.—Weber, R. Zur Verwurmung der Schweiz. Schweiz. med. Wschr, 1941, 71: 1053.—Zerchaninov, L. K. [Helminthic and protozoal affections among the population of the northern regions of the Sverdlovsk district] Med. parazit, Moskva, 1938, 7: 845-8.— Zima, G. G. [Helminthfauna of the natives of the village Beschastnoe and Enthusiast fisheries of the Ikraninsk region of the Stalingrad district] Ibid, 1940, 9: 461.—Zschucke, J, Szidat, L, & Wigand, R. Ein Beitrag zur Kenntnis der Ver- breitung menschlicher Helmintheninfektionen am Kurischen Haff. Zbl. Bakt, 1. Abt, 1932, 124: 1-16. ---- Geography: Latin America. Aguirre Pequeno, E. Iblmintos y helmintiasis; importancia de su pausas de hemate- mesis. Sem. med, B. Air, 1927, 34:^1077-9l.—R-.M. 1. Les hematemeses d'origine peu connue. Praxis, ^%n, •UdA ^i. 431.-Rivers, A. B., & Wilbur, D. L. Intrinsic gastroduodenai lesions as causative factors of hematemesis. Arch. int. M, 1932, 50: 621. Also repr.—Shaw, M. E. The causes and treatment of haematemesis. Clin. J, Lond, 1934, 63: 23-31.— Soldeville, J. M. Hematemesis sin ulcera. Siglo med, 1935, 96: 39.—Valdes, U. Hematemesis de origen hepdtico. An. Sanat. Valdes, 1927, 3: 93-101. ---- Pathology. Aubertin, C, & Lafon, J. Coma et hemiptegie curables cons^cutifs k une hematemese. Presse med, 1940, 48: 656.— Bamford, C. H, & Barber. H. Blindness following haemate- mesis. Lancet, Lond, 1940, 2: 715.—Black, D. A. K. Urea clearance in haematemesis. Ibid, 1939, 1: 323-5. ------ Blood amino-acids in haematemesis. Ibid, 1941, 2: 309.— Pail las, J. E, & Lamy, J. Sur les lesions spl^niques au cours des hematemeses d'allure cryptog€n6tique. Ann. anat. path. Par, 1938, 15: 1061-4.—Schiff, L, Stevens, R. J., & Moss, H. K. The prognostic significance of the blood urea nitrogen following hematemesis or melena. Am. J. Digest. Dis, 1942, 9: 110-3.—Stevens, R. J., Schiff, L. [et al.] Renal function and the azotemia following hematemesis. J. Clin. Invest, 1940, 19: 233-7. Also repr.—Weill-Halle, B, & Loewe-Lyon, S. Anfimie grave avec hematemeses chez un enfant atteint de pneumopathie chronique non tuberculeuse. Bull. Soc. pediat. Paris, 1938, 36: 384-8.—Wilson, A. T. M. Psychological observations on haematemesis. Brit. J. M. Psychol, 1939-40, 18: 112-21. ---- Treatment. Barratt, A. Haematemesis treated with snake (Russell viper) venom by mouth. Brit. M. J, 1936, 2: 1083.—Bastedo, W. A. Medical measures; uses in the treatment of hemate- mesis. Tr. Am. Gastroenter. Ass. (1927) 1928, 30: 107-16. Also Med. J. & Rec, 1927, 126: 333-6.—Black, K. O. Haema- temesis with multiple recurrences treated with repeated blood transfusion by the continuous drip method. Lancet, Lond, 1937, 2: 1430.—Copello, O. La hematemesis; conducta en su presencia. Arch, argent, enferm. ap. digest, 1940-41, 16: 459-70.------ & Etala, E. Las grandes hematemesis; problemas que plantean; conducta terapeutica. Prensa med. argent, 1941,28: 873-80.—Courty.L. Le traitement chirurgical des grandes hematemeses. J. sc. med. Lille, 1922, 40: 345-51.— Fantonetti, G. B. Due casi di ematemesi guarite col concino. Gior. progr. pat, Venez, 1841, 15: 39-42.—Feeding by mouth in haematemesis. Clin. J, Lond, 1937, 66: 297—Gallart y Mones, F. Conducta a seguir ante una hematemesis. Arch. med, Madr, 1928, 29: 149-52.—Gordon-Taylor, G. The attitude of surgery to haematemesis. Lancet, Lond, 1935, 2: 811-5.—Hunter, J. B. Treatment of haematemesis. Ibid, 1431.—Hurst, A. Treatment of haematemesis. In Brit. Encycl. M. Pract. (Rolleston, H.) 1939, Surveys, 47. Also Med. Press & Circ, Lond, 1940, 204: 50. Also In Mod. Treatm. Yearb. (Wakeley, C. P. G.) Lond, 1941, 1-4.— Joll, C. A. The treatment of haematemesis. Postgrad. M. J., Lond, 1938, 14: 17-22.—Jones, A. N. A case of haematemesis treated by gastric lavage. Guy's Hosp. Rep, Lond, 1930, 80: 480-2.—Jones, F. A. Haematemesis and melaena; observa- tions on salt and water requirements. Brit. M. J, 1939, 2: 332-4.—Lanphere, G. H. Recent advances in the treatment of hematemesis and melena. California West. M, 1940, 52: 59-62 —Lazarus, S. Vitamin C nutrition in cases of haema- temesis and melaena. Brit. M. J, 1937, 2: 1011-5.—Mallet- Guy, P. Spienectomie d'urgence pour hematemeses (spieno- megalie primitive type Banti) Lyon chir, 1936, 33: 184-7.— Meulengracht, E. Treatment of hematemesis and melaena with food. Acta med. scand, 1934, Suppl. 59, 375-85. Also Klin. Wschr, 1934, 13: 49. Also Lancet, Lond, 1935, 2: 1220-2.------Treatment of haematemesis and melaena with food; mortality. Acta chir. scand, 1936, 78: 246-50. Behandlung von Hamatemesis und Melana mit uneingeschrankter Kost. Mitt. Ges. inn. Med. Wien, 1936, 35 ■ 52-8 —Morhardt, P. E. Les hematemeses et leur traite- ment. Vie med, 1927, 8: 1247-9.—Namias, G. Intorno all'utilita dell'acetato di piombo e di altri astringenti nelle ematemesi, e alia natura de'easi che ne dimandano l'uso. Gior. progr. pat, Venez, 1841, 15: 43-54.—Nesbitt, S. Case of an haematemesis successfully treated; read before New Haven Medical Society, 1785. Yale J. Biol, 1934, 6: 29-33 — Pietra, G. II problema clinico delle ematemesi da cause occulte dette essenziali. Clinica, Bologna, 1937, 3: 138-56, 2 pl.— Pineda, J. C. Gran hematemesis: tratamiento quirurgico; casos cUnicos; observaciones. Rev. med. cir. Habana, 1928, o3. gig__Rischel, A. [Diet in treatment of hematemesis and melena]' Hospitalstidende 1935, 78: 889-903. —— Wei- tere Erfahrungen mit der Ernahrungsbehandlung bei Haemate- mesis und Melaena nach Meulengracht. Khn. Wschr, 1936, 15 • 335-9 —Shaw, M. E. Attitude of surgery to haemate- mesis. Lancet, Lond, 1935, 2: I030.-Simmonds R A new dietary for haematemesis. Nurs. Times, Lond, 1937, 32- 752-5 —Smyth, M. Attitude of surgery to haematemesis. Lancet, Lond, 1935, 2: 1090.-Syme G. R. A Surgical treat- ment of haematemesis. Austral. N. Zealand J. Surg, 1941-42, 11.7__Tidy H L. The attitude of surgery to haematemesis. Lancet Lond, 1935, 2: 915.—Treatment of haematemesis. Tbid 1936 2: 1463-5.—Whyte, D. The treatment of haemate- mesis. N7 Zealand M. J, 1937, 36: 21-6.-Woldman E. E. The treatment of hematemesis and melena by a continuous aluminum hydroxide drip; a report of 21 cases. Am. J. M. Sc, 1937, 194: 333-40. HEMATIDROSIS 472 HEMATIN HEMATIDROSIS. See also Hysteria, Manifestation; Somatiza- tion. Bianchi, V. Sudor sanguigno e stigmate religiose. Arch. antrop. crim.. Tor, 1926, 46: 152-75. Also Riv. psicol.. 1926, 22: 1-21. Also Vrach. delo, 1920, 9: 1784-8.—Biichler, P. [Psychogenic spontaneous bleeding] Orv. hetil, 1931, 75: [Mell.] 149.—Hyde, J. N. A contribution to the study of bleeding stigmata. J. Cutan. Genitourin. Dis.. 1897, 15: 557-70.—Ichioka, A, & Kato, T. Leber die Pathogenese von den Blutschwitzen des Pferdes. J. Jap. Soc. Vet. Sc, 1935, 14: 217-9, 3 pl.—Kelsall, R. A case of sweating blood. Ind. M. Gaz, 1927, 62: 565.—Sueurs (Les) de sang de Charles IX. Aesculape, Par, 1926, 16: n. ser. No. 3, Suppl. HEMATIN. See also Blood-stain, Identification; Cyto- chrome; Hemin; Hemoglobin; Hematoporphy- ran; Hematoporphyrin; Pyrrol. For the dye hematin see Hematoxylin. Fischer, H, Treibs, A, & Zeile, K. Zur Kenntnis des Hamins, Harnatins und Protoporphyrins. Zschr. physiol. Chem, 1930, 193: 138-06.—Hamsiki A. [Active hematin] Spisy Lek. Lak. Masaryk. Univ., 1929, 7: No. 61-69, 1-13.— Hill, R. Reduced haematin and haemochromogen. Proc. R. Soc, Lond.. 1929, ser. B, 105: 112-30.—McShan, W. H, & Meyer, R. K. Effectiveness of heme in the augmentation of gonadotropic extracts from different sources. Endocrinology 1941, 28: 694-700- Schumm, O. Zui Kenntnis des a-Hama- tius. des pflanzlichen Eisenpoi phyratins und ihrer Porphyrins Zschr. physiol. Chem, 1927, 166: 1; 319.—Wigglonworlh, V. B. Haematin in the tracheae of blood-sucking insects: an artefact. Parasitology, Lond, 1931, 23: 441. —Zhivatov, G. K. [Hematin reaction, as diagnostic method in gynecology and obstetrics] Odess. med. J, 1926, 1: 43-9. ---- Catalytic action. Krebs, H. A. Ueber die Wirkung des Kohlenoxyds auf Hamatinkatalysen nach M. Dixon. Biochem. Zschr, 1928, 201: 489. ------ Ueber Hemmung einer Hamatinkatalyse durch SchwefelwasserstofT. Ibid, 1929, 209: 32.—Wright G. P., & van Alstyne, M. On the oxidation of linseed oil emulsions in the presence of hematin and potassium cyanide J. Biol. Chem, 1931, 93: 71-82. ---- Chemistry. Barkan, G, & Olesk, J. Ueber den Farbwert saurer Ha- matinlosungen. Biochem. Zschr.', 1936-37, 289: 251-65.— Berthier, P. Coefficient d'aimantation et signe eiectrique des solutions d'hematine et d'acethemine. C. rend Acad sc 1938, 207: 1254-6—Conant, J. B., Alles, C. A, & Tongberg! C. O. The electrometric titration of hemin and hematin' J. Biol. Chem, 1928, 79: 89-93.—Elvehjem, C. A. The prepa- ration of standard acid hematin solutions from hemin Ibid 1931. 93: 203-10. Also repr.—Fischer, H, Treibs, A, A Zeile, K. Ueber den Mechanismus der Eiseneinfiihrung in Porphyrine und Isolierung von krystallisierten Ilarnen Z^ehr Physiol. Chem, 1931, 195: 1-27.—Hamsik, A. [Cher Addi- tionsvermogen des Hiimatins. Ibid, 1930, 190: 199-221.— Hill, R, & Keilin, D. Estimation of haematin iron and the oxidation-reduction equivalent of cytochrome C Proc R Soc, Lond, 1933, ser. B, 114: 104-9— Jodlbauer, A. Das verschiedene Verhalten der Neutralsalze bei der Hypertonie- hamolyse und bei der Bildung von Saurehiimatin, sowie der Einfluss von Zucker auf diese beiden Vorgange. Arch exD Path, Berl, 1935, 178: 719-23.—Lintzel, W, & Radeff, T. Ueber die Hiimatinbildung aus CO-Hamoglobin und Oxy- hemoglobin durch verdiinnte Sauren. Biochem. Zschr, 1928 203: 212-7.—Papendieck, A. Bemerkung iiber die katalytische Hydnerung von Hamaterinsaure und Hamin. Zschr nhvsiol Chem 1927, 169: 59-63.—Roche, J. Sur la teneur en oxygene delhematine. C. rend. Soc. biol, 1926, 94: 461-3. ---- Derivatives. See also Hemochromogen; Hemopyrrol. Florkin, M. Biochimie des derives d'hemes et d'hematines Congr. pharm. Liege (1934) 1935, 98-102.—Hamsik, A. [Com- plex combinations of hematines and hemins] Spisv Lek Fak Masaryk. Univ. 1930. 8: 267-76-Lemberg! R., cUfs-Jones; B., & !Vor"e- >>• An oxyporphyrin haematin compound as intermediate between_ protohaematin and verdohaematin. Nature, Lond, 1937, 139: 65.------ Chemical mechanism of the oxidation of protohaematin to verdohaematin Bio- chem L, Lond, 1938 32: 171-86.-Schumm, O. Zur Kenntn^ der Seitenkettenreaktionen des Harnatins; uber die Um- ^A m^5 V°n ?wum?ti'} inTdTen Hamatoporphyrinmethylather und Morners Methode der Hamatingewinnung; kurze Mittei- lung. Zschr. physiol. Chem, 1927, 170- 161-6 xy"1™ Mertens E. Ueber die umkehrbare Seitenkettenreaktion ^Tatme r\nd ^f, Verhalte£ de« Hamins und der Hamatine gegen Sauren; Darstellung der Hamaterinsaure aus Hamin und orgawschen Sauren. Ibid, 1928, 177: 15-33.—Siedel W & Moller, H. Leber Mesobilifuscin, ein neues physiologischca Abbauproibikt des Hiims beriehungsweise ILimatins; Konstitu- tion und Teilsynthese. Ibid, 1939, 259: 113-30. ---- Deuterohematin (Copratin) Schalij, G. Investigations about deuterohematin (copratin) Acta brevia neerl, 1940, 10: 225-7.- Schumm, O. Uehcr Umwandlungsprodukte der Farbstoffe aus I leiseh und Hint; iiber ein aus a-Hamatin bei der Darmfaulnis entsprerhendci Umwandlungsprodukt (Kopratin) und das zugehiirige Porphy- rin; Kopratin und Pyridinblutprobe. Zschr. physiol. Chem 1925, 149: 1-18, pl. ------ Ueber Umwandlungsprodukte der Farbstoffe aus Fleisch und Blut (Fortsetzung der Unter- suchung) die Entstehung von Kopratin bei der frciwilligen Faulnis von Blut; spektrochemische Rcakfionen des aus dem Kopratin dargestellten krystallisierten Kopratoporphyrins Ibid, 1926, 159: 194-8.—Verhagen, H. [On copratinel Ned. tschr. geneesk, 1939, 83: 1645-50. ---- enzymatic, and cellular. See also Cytochrome. Elliott, K. A. C, & Keilin, D. The haematin content of horseradish peroxidase. Proc. R. Soc, Lond, 1934, ser B 114: 210-22.—Keilin, D., & Hartree, E. F. On some properties of catalase haematin. Ibid, 1930, ser. B, 121: 173-91.__ Keilin, D, & Mann, T. On the haematin compound of peroxi- dase. Ibid, 1937, ser. B, 122: 119-33.— Roche, J. Actinio- hematine et cytochrome. C. rend. Soc. biol, 1932, 111: 904-6. ------ Les pigments hematiniques des actiniea (actiniohematine) et le cytochrome b. Ibid, 1936, 121: 69-71 Also Bull. Soc. chim. biol. Par, 1936, 18: 82.5-40. -----& Bfinevent. M. T. Hematines c et cytochrome e; mobilite du fer et combinaisons des hematines avec une globine. C. rend Soc. biol, 1936, 123: 18. ------ Hematines cellulaires et cytochromes. Ibid, 20-2.—Stern, K. G. Structure and action-mechanism of hematin-containing enzymes. Yale J Biol, 1937-38, 10: 161-78. ---- Hemin. Barkan, G, & Schales, O. Ein wasserlosliches c-Hamin aus Blut. Zschr. physiol. Chem, 1937, 246: 181-93.—Barron, E. S. G. The oxidation-reduction potentials of spirographis hemin and of some of its hemochromogens. J. Biol. Chem, 1937, |119: p. vi.—Bruckner, J. Ueber ein mit Ameisensauro dargestelltes Hamin. Biochem. Zschr, 1934, 268: 181-6.— Conant, J. B, & Tongberg, C. O. The oxidation-reduction potentials of hemin and related substances; the potentials of various hemins and hematins in the absence and presence of pyridine. J. Biol. Chem, 1930, 86: 733-41.—Corwin, A. H, & Krieble, R. H. A reinvestigation of the configuration hemin. J. Am Chem. Soc, 1941, 63: 1829-34.—Cremer, W. Notiz iiber die Reduktion von Hamin durch Cystein. Biochem. Zschr, 1928, 192: 120— Drabkin, D. L. Spectrophotometric studies; the nncrodetermination of iron in cytochrome C and hemin preparations. J. Biol. Chem, 1941, 140: 387-96 Also repr-Fischer, H. Synthese des Hamins. Munch, med. Wschr, 1929, 76: 461. Also Naturwissenschaften, 1929, 17: o • », , Ueber Hamin und Porphyrine. Verh. Deut. Ges. inn Med, 1933, 45. Kongr., 7-27.------& Libowitsky. H. Ueberfuhrung von Kopro-hamin I in Kopro-glaukobilin. £schr. physiol. Chem, 1938, 251: 198-203.—Fischer, H, & Schwerdtel, F. Zur Kenntnis der naturlichen Porphyrine; Gewinnung von Hamin aus Hefe. Ibid, 1928, 175: 248-60, pl— Fischer H, & Seemann, C. von. Die Konstitution des Spirographishamins. Ibid, 1936, 242: 133-7—Goldman, H. Ueber em Citrylhamin. Biochem. Zschr, 1926 172- 127-32 — Hamsik, A. Ueber Porphyrine aus Oxyhaminanhydrid. Zschr. physiol. Chem, 1926, 156: 218-30. ------ Ueber Pyridinhamine. Ibid, 1927, 169: 64-72. ------ Zur Dar- stellung der unveranderten Modifikation des Oxyhamins und des Chorhamins. Ibid, 1928, 176: 173-86.---— Zur RSc^"""fder krystallisierten K-Salze des Oxyhamins. Ibid, 1929, 182: 117-24. ------ Ueber die Einwirkung der Ameisen- saure auf das Oxy- und Chlorhamin. Ibid, 183: 103-12. -Alterung des Oxyhamins beim Trocknen. Ibid, 269- ■>t't. ioq « eber da?HyPophosphithamin. Ibid, 1938, It i j, ■---TT [Pyridin hemins] Spisy Lek. Fak. Masaryk. Vmv 1927 5: No. 9, l-7.-Ide. M. L'hemine syntri6tique. Rev. med, Louvain, 1929, 324-7 —KobI F. Die Synthese des Hamins. Klin. Wschr, 1929, 8: 1872-4 — £,rfw-w i " * Veber dje. Wirkung von Kohlenoxyd und Licht aut rlaminkatalysen. Biochem. Zschr, 1928, 193: 347-9.— vr!J.n ™ Xf-1 ^Uu,beN uin Additionsprodukt von Chlor an ein Monomethyl (chlor) hamin. Zschr. physiol. Chem, 1924, 141: Thirl 'io9R~~,T, VfrbeLden basischen Charakter des Hamins. Pornb, • k' ,!<53: H^24J. ------ Ueber de^ Chemismus der 997 imbol^n§ound dle Konstitution des Hamins. Ibid, mminc \ua T^o ,"^TT7 Ueber i-somere nicht alkylierte W; Ibld' 173: ^S-SS. ------& Bosch, H. Ueber den H,?r^^H--r-Porr,^nn,b«lldunB: 0,,er die Addition von Halogen an Hamin. Ibid, 72-97.-Kuster, W., & von Degen- rfnhi V ' Ueber porT?hy»ne; uber den Chemismus der Porphy- K«« L,Un^ ai>s^-.Haminen. Ibid, 1929, 180: 259-69.- PornhvA"rM& F,e,8chmann' ?-, Ueber Porphyrine; uber die {7»?^S£ildu£!?.aj» monoathyherten Haminen. Ibid, 1927, hlmW^ jwa~^^%Y W^' & Neunhoffer, O. Ueber Fluor- hamin. Ibid, 179-81.—Kuster, W., & Ruff, W. Ueber die HEMATIN 473 HEMATOBLAST Einwirkung von Benzoylperoxyd auf ein Dimethyl-(chlor)- hamin. Ibid, 1926, 151: 98-113.— Kiister, W., & Schlayer, K. Ueber Porphyrine; iiber den Chemismus der Porphyrinbilduny und die Konstitution des Hamins. Ibid, 1927, 168: 294-314. _____Ueber den Chemismus der Porphyrinspaltung bei substituierten Haminen und die Konstitution des Hamins. Ibid, 1929, 180: 270-85.—Kuhn, R, & Meyer, K. Ueber katalytische Oxydationen mit Hamin. Ibid, 185: 193-216.— Meshcherskaia-Steinberg, K. A. [Investigation of hemin svstem poisons and their detoxication on nucleated erythocytes] Farm. & toks, Moskva, 1939, 2: No. 3, 44-9.—Morrison, D. B & Williams, E. F, jr. Acid properties of hemin and ferri- hemic acid. Proc. Am. Soc. Biol. Chem, 1938, 8: No. 7, 87. -----The solubility and titration of hemin and ferrihemic acid. J. Biol. Chem, 1941, 137: 461-73.—Negelein, E. Ver- brennung von Kohlenoxyd zu Kohlensaure durch grune und mischfarbene Hamine. Biochem. Zschr, 1931, 243: 386-95. Kryptohamin. Ibid, 1932, 248: 243-5. Ueber die Extraktion eines von Bluthamin verschiedenen Hamins aus dem Herzmuskel. Ibid, 1933, 266: 412-6.— Partos, A. Ueber ein mutmassliches Citrylhiimin. Ibid, 1926, 172: 126.—Richter, A. F. Zur Komplexchemie des Eisens in a-Haminen. Zschr. physiol. Chem, 1938, 253: 193- 216.------[Modification of protohemins prepared from analytic protoporphyrin] Spisy Lek. Fak. Masaryk. Univ., 1930, 8: 53, S. a72; 221, S. a83.—Schales, O. Ein wasser- losliches c-Hamin aus Blut. Zschr. physiol. Chem, 1938-39, 257: 121-8.—Schumm, O. Ueber einige neue Verfahren zur Gewinnung von Haminderivaten. Ibid, 1928, 176: 122-6. -----Ueber die Gewinnung von Haminderivaten durch Brenzreaktionen. Ibid, 178: 1-18, pl. ------ Ueber die Gewinnung von Haminderivaten durch Brenzreaktionen. Ibid 1929, 185: 81-98, 2 pl.—Warburg, O, & Christian, W. Ueber Phalhamin b. Biochem. Zschr., 1931, 235: 240-2 — Warburg, O, & Kubowitz, F. Ueber katalytische Wirkung von Bluthaminen und von Chlorophyll-Haminen. Ibid, 1930, 227: 184-99.—Warburg, O, & Negelein, E. Notiz iiber Spiro- graphishamin. Ibid, 1932, 244: 239-42. ------ & Haas, E. Spirographishamin. Ibid, 1930, 227: 171-83. --- Hemin: Diagnostic use. See also Blood-stain, Identification. Pasqtjale, C. *Sobre duas modificacoes do metodo de Strzyzowski, para obtenigao dos cristais de Teichmann. 69p. 8? S. Paulo, 1932. Bertrand, G. Sur un reactif permettant l'obtention facile des cristaux d'hemine et leur montage k partir du sang. Bull. Acad, med. Par, 1931, 3. ser, 106: 386-9. Also Bull. sc. pharm. Par, 1931, 38: 673-7.—Ferreira, A. A. Crystaes de Teichmann; contribuigao para o seu estudo. Ann. Fac. med. S. Paulo, 1928, 3: 145-56, 10 pl.—Kriiger, F. von. Zur Aus- fiihrung der Teichmannschen Haminprobe. Zschr. ges. exp. Med, 1934-35, 95: 736-8.—Lecha-Marzo, A. Los cristales de hemina y hemocromogeno. Progr. clin, Madr, 1916, 7: 65- 92.—Read, B. E. Hemin crystals prepared from camel's blood. J. Biochem, Tokyo, 1925, 5: 99-103.—Scatamacchia, E. La preparazione dei cristalli di emina col metodo Tamassia- Ottolenghi e col metodo Strzyzowsky da sangue normale e sottoposto all'azione di elevate temperature. Zacchia, 1932-33, 11:-12: 137-45. HEMATINEMIA. See also Porphyrinuria. Bingold, K. Weitere Untersuchungen uber das Vorkommen von Hamatin in Blutserum bei Menschen und Tieren. Khn. Wschr, 1926, 5: 1550-2.—Fieschi, A, & Gavazzem, M. Ricerche sull'ematinemi'a; i suoi rapporti col ricambio emo- globinico, col ferro inorganico e con la bihrubinemia; suo valore diagnostico. Fisiol. & med, Roma, 1932, 3: 315-25— Medovyi, I. [Hematinemia in certain cases of chemical poisoning) I arm. & toks, Moskva, 1941, 4: No. 4, 34-9.—Morrison, D. B, Williams, E. F., jr, & Anderson, W. A. D. Studies on hematin metabolism in dogs. J. Biol. Chem, 1940, 133: Proc, 70.— Schumm, O. Haematin als pathologischer Bestandteil des Blutes. Zschr. physiol. Chem, 1916, 97: 32-52. ------ Spektrochemische Untersuchungen an Porphyrinen und Hamatinen; iiber den Nachweis von Koproporphyrin und die Bedeutung spektrochemischer Methoden fur die Porphynn- und Porphvratinforschung; iiber das im Blutserum Kranker auftretende* Hamatin. Ibid, 1926, 152: 1-17. HEMATINURIA. See Hemoglobinuria. HEMATOBLAST. See also Blood formation; Erythroblast; Ery- throcytopoiesis; Hemoblastosis, &c. Achard, C, & Hynaud, M. Sur les hematoblastes des vertebres ovipares. C. rend. Soc. biol, 1907, 63: 054. Betances, L. M. Qu'est-ce qu'un hemohistoblaster O. rend. Acad, sc, 1924, 178: 2269-72—Chevrel & Roger. Isolement des hematoblastes; production d'un serum antihematoblastique. C. rend. Soc. biol, 1907, 63: 501— Fontana, A. Hemolusto- blastes basophiles et leurs derives. Arch. mal. cceur, 1927 20: 769-77, Pl—Fontana, L. Dell'origine e del significato' dei cosl detti nuclei liberi negli esami ematologici. Minerva med , lor, 1925, 5: 865-9.—Melissinos, C. N. Des hematoblastes et de eur transformation en erythrocytes dans l'omentum majeur de 1 embryon des chats, des chiens, des cochons et de I'homme. Grdce med, 1900, 2: 110.—Richter, M. N. Observations on the hemohistioblastof Ferrata. Am. J. M. Sc, 1925, 169: 336-45.— Villa, L. La presenza in circolo dell' emoistioblasto di Ferrata e Franco non e sol tan to di alcune emopatie primitive. Arch. sc. med. Tor, 1929, 53: 700-4. HEMATOBLAST [of Hayem] For the rest of the literature see Blood platelet. Hayem, G. L'hematoblaste, troisieme element du sang. 295p. 8? Par., 1923. Achard, C, & Aynaud. Sur l'observation directe des hemato- blastes dans le plasma sanguin. C. rend. Soc. biol, 1907, 63: 593-5.—Hayem, G. Sur le noyau de l'hematoblaste des vivi- pares, k propos du travail de M. Ed. Retterer, intitule: du role hematiformateur de la rate du chien, du chat et du cheval. Ibid, 1915, 78: 519. ------ Examen critique de quelques travaux sur l'anatomie et sur la physiologie de l'hematoblaste. Sang, Par, 1928, 2: 109-65.—Le Sourd, L., & Pagniez, P. Un procede d'isolement k l'etat de purete des hematoblastes du sang. C. rend. Acad, sc, 1906, 142: 1562. ------ Con- tribution a la question de l'origiue des hematoblastes. C. rend. Soc. biol, 1907, 63: 561-3.—Neumann, E. Die Spindelzellen des Amphibienblutes (Hayems Hamatoblasten) Arch. mikr. Anat. Entwmech, 1910-11, 76: 725-44.—Pappenheim, A. Hayems Haematoblasten sind identisch mit den als Blut- plattchen bezeichneten Gebilden. Lav. riv. chim. micr. clin, 1908-9, 1: 97-120, pl.—Petri, S. Sur la technique employee pour la numeration des hematoblastes d'aprds la methode de Thomsen, dans les recherches experimentales sur les animaux. C. rend. Soc. biol, 1924, 90: 881-4. ------ Sur la numeration des hematoblastes d'apres la methode de Thomsen. Ibid, 91: 405-8. HEMATOCELE. See also Hematoma; also names of body cavities and parts affected as Pelvis; Peritoneum; Scrotum; Spleen. Knetsch, A. *Zur solitaren ausschalbaren Hematocele [Breslau] 19p. 8? Borna, 1927. Ord6nez Moreno, A. N. *La velocidad de sedimentaci6n de los hematies en la clinica; su aplicacion en el diagn6stico de la hematoceles. 141p. 8? Santiago, 1930. Severin, J. R. P. *Ueber die Entstehung und Klinik der Blutcysten [Marburg] 31p. 8? [Marb., 1925] Hamant. Hematocele ancienne. Bull. Soc. obst. gyn. Paris, 1926, 15: 452.—Sigalas. Diagnostic de l'hematoceie par le reaction de sedimentation. Gyn. obst. Par, 1927, 16: 24-9.—Trillat, P, Michon & Buolez. Emploi du lipiodol dans un cas d'hematocele de diagnostic difficile. Bull. Soc. obst. gyn. Paris, 1933, 22: 420.—Zhivatov, G. K. [Diagnosis of ante- uterine hematocele] Odess. med- J, 1928, 3: 719. HEMATOCHYLURIA. See under Chyluria. HEMATOCOLPOS. See Gynatresia; Hymen, imperforate; Vagina, Hematoma; Vagina, Stenosis. HEMATOCRIT. Sec also Blood, Examination; Centrifuge; Hematology, Instruments. Kollath, W. Ein neuer Hamatoknt. Munch, med. V\ schr, 1929 76: 1465.—McLean, J. A. Haematocrit determination in normal and abnormal blood. Med. J. Australia, 1938, 2: 770-4 —Marenzi, A. D, & Lida, E. Disposittvo para limpiar hematocritos. An. farm, bioquim, B. Air, 1941, 12: 97-9.— Miller ATA simple and accurate hematocrit tube. J. Lab. Clin! M, 1938-39, 24: 547—Pratt, O. B, & Swartout, H O A handy double-purpose hematocrit. Arch. Bath, Phic 1930 9-09 Also repr.—Rosahn, P. D. A new capillary hematocriL Proc. Soc. Exp. Biol, N. Y, 1930-31, 28: 491. HEMATOCYTE. See Blood cell. HEMATOCYTOZOON. See Hematozoa. HEMATO-ENCEPHALIC 474 HEMATOLOGY HEMATO-ENCEPHALIC barrier. See under Cerebrospinal cavity; also Meninges. HEMATOHISTIOBLAST. See Hematoblast; also Leukocyte; Lympho- cyte; Monocyte, &c. HEMATOIDIN. See also Blood coagulation; Hemoglobin; Hemorrhage. Niven, J. S. F. The formation of heematoidin in vitro from mammalian erythrocytes. J. Path. Bact, Cambr, 1935, 41 : 177-81. HEMATOLOGY. See also Blood; Hematopoietic system; Sero- logy. Internationale hamatologische Tagung. 1. Tagung, Munster—Pyrmont, 8-15 Mai 1937. Sitzungsbericht. 248p. 23^cm. Berl. [1938] Tru, B. Life—blood. 173p. 19cm. Bost. [1938] Babor, J. F. [Theoretical observations on clinical hema- tology] Bratisl. lek. listy, 1940. 20: Suppl, 67-71.—Becton, C. M. The usefulness and responsibilities of medical tech- nologists in the practice of routine hematology. Am. J. Techn, 1940, 6: 60-8.—Blount, W. P. Haematology in veterinary practice. Vet. Rec, Lond, 1930, 10: 207-9.— Castro Villagrana, J. Distinguido hemat61ogo. In his Entre cirujan. fi: 269; passim.—Klima, R. Xeue Arbeiten fiber Blutkrank- heiten und klinische Hiimatologie. Med. Klin, Berl, I'.Hl, 37: 515-7.—Lambin, P. Hematologic. Rev. beige sc. m6d, 1929, 1: 54-69.—Lottrup. M. C. Sammelreferat Uber danische Literatur (1933 und 1934) Fol. haemat, Lpz, 1936, 55: 283-304.—McCrie. Englische hamatologische Literatur (1933) Ibid, 1934-35, 53: 440; 1935-36, 54: 93.— Milman, M. Etude* hematologiques. Sang, Par, 1934, 8: 481-522.—Osgood, E. E. Recent advances in hematology. Texas .1. M, 1938-39, 34: 416-9.—Pincus, W. Revue de litterature hematologique anglaise. Sang, Par, 1939, 13: 763-89.—Rossier, P. H. Franzosische hamatologische Literatur (II. Semester 1933) Fol. haemat, Lpz, 1936, 55: 115-37.—Schulten, H, & Ktlhl, H. Bibliographie der deutschen hamatologischen Literatur 1938. Ibid, 1939, 63: 100-23.—Sturgis, C. C, Isaacs, R. [et al.] Blood; a review of the recent literature. Arch. Int. M, 1939, 63: 1190; passim.—Wallbach, G. Revue de littera- ture hematologique neerlandaise 1936-1938. Sang, Par, 1939, 13:416-32.—Weil, P. E, & Lamy, M. L'hematologie. Monde med, 1931, 41:426-36. ------ L'hematologie; les nouveautea de 1933. Ibid, 1934, 44: 522-38. ---- Manual, Alcayde, J. Indicaciones e interpretaci6n de los analisis de sangre en clinica. 207p. 23#cm. [Habana] 1934. Becart, A. Le sang; abrege1 d'hematologie. 132p. 8? Par., 1927. Bezancon, Le Sourd [et al.] Sang, organea hematopoietiques, rate, os. 544p. 8? Par., 1922. Bonanno, A. M. Ematologia radiologica; il sangue nell'esperienza e nella pratica, alio stato normale e patologico di fronte alle radia- zioni Roentgen. 434p. 8? Nap., 1931. Domarus, A. von. Einfiihrung in die Hama- tologie. 4. Aufl. 185p. 8? Lpz., 1929. Downey, H. Handbook of hematology. 4v. 8? N. Y., 1938. Frey, J. Diseases of the blood. 194p. 22cm. N. Y. [1939] Haden, R. L. Principles of hematology. 34Sp. 24cm. Phila. [1939] Also 2. ed. 362p. 11940] Hirschfeld, H., & Hittmair, A. Handbuch der allgemeinen Hamatologie. 3v. 8°. Berl., 1932-33. Hittmair, A. Blutdiagnostik fur den prak- tischen Arzt. 2. verb. Aufl. 115p. 21cm. Berl., 1939. Jordan, H. E. Comparative hematology. p.703-862. 8? N. Y., 1938. Kracke, R. R. Diseases of the blood and atlas of hematology. 2. ed- 692p. 26^cm. Phila. [1941] ----& Garver, H. E. Diseases of the blood and atlas of hematology [1. ed.l 532p. roy. 8? Phila. [1937] Lehndorff, H. Hamatologisches Nachschla- gebuch fur den praktischen Arzt. 58p. 8° Wien, 1937. Magner, W. A textbook of hematology. 395p. 8? Phila. [1938] Merklen, P., & Waitz, R. Atlas d'hema- tologie. 213p. 26cm. Par., 1938. Montpellier, J., & Manceaux, A. Pratique hematologique. 328p. 8? Par., 1933. Naegeli, O. Blutkrankheiten und Blut- diagnostik; Lehrbuch der klinischen Hamatologie. 5. Aufl. 704p. 8? Berl., 1931. Osgood, E. E., & Ashworth, C. M. Atlas of hematology. 255p. 4? S. Franc. [1937] Pepper, O. H. P., & Farley, D. L. Practical hematological diagnosis. 502p. 8? Phila., 1933. Schtjdel, L. Leitfaden der Blutmorphologie. 45p. 8? Lpz., 1936. HEMATOLOGY 475 HEMATOMA Schtjlten, H. Lehrbuch der klinischen Hamatologie. 459p. 25^cm. Lpz., 1939. Varela, M. E. Lecciones de hematologia. 390p. 23cm. B. Air., 1938. Wirth, D. Grundlagen einer klinischen Hamatologie der Haustiere. 311p. 8° Berl., 1931. ___Methods, and instruments. See also Blood, Examination; Blood picture; Hematocrit, &c. Beck, R. G. Laboratory manual of hema- tologic technic. 389p. 24cm. Phila., 1938- Bucher, R. Die Diffusionsanalyse am Blut- plasmagel; ein neuer Weg der Blutforschung. 123p. 8? Basel, 1937. Enghoff, H. Quantitative Hamoglobinbe- stimmungen und Erythrozytenuntersuchungen. 389p. 24J/2cm. Upps. [1937] Adie, J. R. A plea for scraps. Ind. M. Gaz, 1907, 42: 250- 5, pl.—Bell, G. H. Nomograms for hsematologists. Glasgow M J , 1939, 132: 16-21.—Boerner.F. Hematological standards. Am. J. Clin. Path, 1939, 9: Suppl, 75.—Bufalini, M. Osser- vazioni sul sangue umano, e considerazioni sui metodi di piu conveniente investigazione intorno ai fenomeni dei corpi organici. Gior. progr. pat, Venez, 1838, 9: 384-506.— Castellanos, I. Hematologia forense. Vida nueva, Habana, 1932, 29: 483-557, 21 pl.—Doan, C. A. The clinical implica- tions of experimental hematology. Medicine, Bait, 1931, 10: 323-71.—Florentin, P, & Verain, M. Notes pratiques d'hema- tologie. Rev. med. Nancy, 1936, 64: 249-52.—Hittmair, A. Die Methoden der Fehlerrechnungen und Wahrscheinlich- keitsrechnungen in der hamatologischen Technik. In Handb. allg. Hamat. (Hirschfeld) Berl, 1933, 2: 1. Halfte, 319-28 — Hollosi, K, & Martzy, I. [Gynecological importance of hema- tologic examination of blood talcen from the superficial parts and the female genitals] Budapesti orv. ujs, 1935, 33: 969- 72.—Lee, C. D. Device for recording pulse waves, respiration, and blood pressure changes. U. S. Patent Off, 1941, No. 2,235,894.—Levadite, C, & Stanesco, V. Sur un procede facilitant la recherche des trypanosomes, des spirilles et des filaires dans le sang. C. rend. Soc. biol, 1909, 67: 594-6.— Meyer-Hartmann, W. Hamatologie in der Praxis. Schweiz. med. Wschr, 1939, 69: 170-2.—Milman, M. S. [Hematological research] Tr. Gistol. konf, Moskva (1934) 1935, 1. Conf, 192.—Napier, L. E, & Das Gupta, C. R. Haematological technique. Ind. M. Gaz, 1940, 75: 290; passim.—Nassau, E. Ueber die Aufbewahrung von Blutausstrichen in Kranken- geschichten. Schweiz. med. Wschr, 1941, 71: 1504.—Nyfeldt, A. [Hematologic research] Ugeskr. laeger, 1930, 92: 491.— Perez Gallardo, R. Concepto moderno del estudio hemato- 16gico. Rev. cir. Hosp. Judrez, Mex, 1936, 7: 47-54 Nociones de hematologia prdctica. Ibid, 335-43.—Piney, A. The importance of haematology in surgery. Brit. J. Surg, 1926- 27, 14: 9-35.—Portes, F, & Benoit, C. Etude histochimique du sang des ascidies (application de la methode de Ross) Bull. Soc. sc. med. biol. Montpellier, 1922-23, 4: 144-6 — Saito, T. Die durch subkutane Injektion von Karmin, Tusche und einigen anderen Substanzen in der Ohrmuschel des Kanin- chens bedingte Monozytose. Fol. haemat, Lpz, 1931-32, 46: 59-92.—Schilling, V. Kursus der praktischen Blutlehre. Sitzber. Internat. hamat. Tagung (1937) 1938, 1. Congr, 5.—Schoger, A. Hamatologie fiir die Praxis. Hippokrates, Stuttg, 1939, 10: 976-81.—Stern, L. D. The hematology laboratory in hospital practice. Harper Hosp. Bull, Detr, 1941, 1: 22-4. HEMATOMA. See also Hematocele; Hemorrhage; also under names of parts affected as Abdomen, Hemorrhage; Abdominal wall, Hematoma, &c. Hofmann, N. *Ueber Hamatome und ihre Organisation [Giessen] 19p. 8? Birkenfeld, 1931. Bahlmann, C. Zur Frage der vitalen Reaktion des Binde- gewebes in Hamatomen. Deut. Zschr. gerichtl. Med, 1939, 32: 133-44.—Berglin, C. G. [Treatment of small hematomas] Sven. lak. tidn, 1938, 35: 2134.—Bullitt, J. B. Ossifying hema- toma. California West. M, 1927, 27: 508-11.—Cone, S. M. Ossifying hematoma. J. Bone Surg, 1928, 10: 474-82 — Eliason, E. L. Ossifying haematoma. Internat. Clin, 1928, 38. ser, 2: 84-93, 17 pl.—Fedorovich, D. P. [Relation of hematoma to post-operative hemorrhages and to disorders of blood coagulation] Mosk. med. J, 1929, 9: 10-3.—Frigerio, A. Haematoma ingravescens a caratteri clinici non comuni. Arch. antrop. crim. Tor, 1937, 57: Suppl, 369-75.—Gotze, R. Die Hamatomkrankheit (Hamatomosis) bei Rindern. Deut. tier- arztl. Wschr, 1941, 49: 9.—Hall, I. C. A traumatic hematoma infected with Bacillus welchii. J. Am. M. Ass, 1927, 89: 1241- 3.—Higgins, G. M„ & Palmer, B. M. The origin of fibro- blasts within an experimental hematoma. Arch. Path Chic 1929, 7: 63-70—Hurley, V. Office treatment of hematoma! Am. J. Surg, 1930, n. ser, 8: 358-60.—Kamniker, K. Aus- gedehnte Verkalkung bei einem 20 Jahre alten Hamatom. Deut. Zschr. Chir,1933-34, 242: 179-82.—Kartavin, V. A. [Pathogenesis of post-operative hematomas] Vest, khir, 1941, 61: 19-25.—Laszlo, F. Zur Hamatomkrankheit des Rindes! Deut. tierarztl. Wschr, 1941, 49: 244.—Nordmann, O. Das Hamatom; Blut- und Lymphzysten; decollement; Hautem- physem. Med. Klin, Berl, 1939, 35: 1238.—Palma, E. C. Contribuci6n al diagn6stico arteriogrdfico de los hematomas pulsdtiles. Arch. urug. med, 1939, 14: 461-79.—Prima, C. Wundstorungen und Hamatomfurcht. Zbl. Chir, 1938, 65: 2328-32.—Rieder, W. Naht oder Ligatur bei kommunizieren- den Hamatomen unter besonderer Berucksichtigung der Dauer- ergebnisse. Arch. klin. Chir, 1926, 141: 613-27.—Riese, J. Hamatomfurcht und Hamatomverhiitung. Zbl. Chir, 1938, 65: 1059-64.—Shipley, A. M. Ossifying hematoma and allied conditions. Arch. Surg, 1940, 41: 516-24.—Stone, C. A. Ossifying hematoma. J. Am. M. Ass, 1926, 87: 1885-8. Also repr.—Weitz, F., & Strong, R. A. Calcified hematoma. J. Pediat, S. Louis, 1939, 14: 522-6.—Wette, W. Ossifizie- rendes Hamatom oder Sarkom? Zbl. Chir, 1941, 68: 456-9. HEMATOMETRA. See under Uterus. HEMATOMYELIA. See under Spinal cord. HEMATOPOIESIS. See Blood formation. HEMATOPOIETIC system. See also Blood; Blood cell; Blood formation; Bone marrow; Erythrocyte; Hematology, &c. Jantke, J. J., & Selig, J. C. [resp.] *De sanguificatiohe. 28p. 19cm. Altdorf [1723] Wisconsin. University. Medical school. A symposium on the blood and blood-forming organs. 264p. 24cm. Madison [1939] Alexandrov, A. F. Die Morphologie des Sternumpunktates von Hunden. Fol. haemat, Lpz, 1930, 41: 428-34, pl, tab.— Bianchi, A. E, & Ramirez Corria, C. M. Sobre la estructura y valor funcional del estroma de las 6rganos hematopoyeticos. Rev. Soc. argent, biol, 1925, 1: 752-61. Also C. rend. Soc. biol, 1926, 94: 489-91.—Dubreuil, G. Lecons sur les organes lymphopoietiques, hematopoietiques et hematolytiques; apercu d'ensemble sur le systeme lymphopoietique et hematopoietique. Gaz. sc. med. Bordeaux, 1922, 43: 378-80.—Eatable, C. Ob- servations sur I'appareil de Golgi dans les cellules du sang et des organes hematopoietiques. C. rend. Soc. biol, 1931, 106: 841-4.—Forkner, C. E. Blood and bone marrow cells of the domestic fowl. J. Exp. M, 1929, 50: 121-41, pl.—Giovanni, L. Le plasmacellule negli organi emopoietici della serie animale. Monit. zool. ital, 1933, 44: Suppl, 179-82.—Meyer, E. Die blutbildenden Organe. Jahrkurs arztl. Fortbild, 1912, 3. H, 68-94.—Ogata, T. Ueber die Systemeinteilung der hamato- poetischen Gewebe. Jap. J. M. Sc, 1940, 5: Path, 1-12 — Wetzel, G. Die blutbildenden Organe. In Handb. Anat. Kind. (K. Peter) Munch, 1928, 1: 140-89.—Yoshinaka, K. Ueber den Cholesteringehalt der blutbildenden Organe. Okayama igakkai zasshi, 1928, 40: 2524. ---- Disease. See also Agranulocytosis; Anemia; Blood, Disease; Erythroblastosis; Hemoblastosis; Hemo- globinuria; Hemophilia; Leukosis; Reticulosis; Spleen, Disease, &c. Achard, C. Legons cliniques sur les maladies du sang et des organes hematopoietiques. 270p. 8? Par., 1931. Adler, E., Alder, A. [et al.] Blut und Lymphe. Erster Teil: Blut. 665p. 8? Berl., 1928. Arneth, J. Die speziellen Blutkrankheiten im Lichte der qualitativen Blutlehre. 3v. 8°. Munster, 1928-34. ,,„,,. , Benard, H., Tissier, M. [et al.] Maladies du sang. 771p. 8? Par., 1931. Clough, P. W. Diseases of the blood. 310p. 16? N. Y., 1929. Ewing, J. Clinical pathology of the blood; a treatise on the general principles and special HEMATOPOIETIC 476 HEMATOPOIETIC applications of hematology. 2. ed. -195p. 8? X. V., 1903. Ferrata, A. Le emopatie; trattato per medici c studenti. v.l: Parte generale. 504p. 8? Milano, 1918. Also 2. ed. 3v. 1933-34. Grawitz, E. Klinische Pathologie des Blutes nebst einer Methodik der Blutuntersuchungen und spezieller Pathologie und Therapie der Blutkrankheiten. lOllp. 8? Lpz., 1911. Herz, A. Blutkrankheiten. p.547-632. 8°. Dresd., 1929. Hirschfeld, H. Lehrbuch der Blutkrank- heiten fiir Arzte und Studierende. 2. Aufl. 263p. 8? Lpz., 1928. Isaacs, R. Diseases of the blood and blood- forming organs, p.573-673. 25cm. N. Y., 1941. Jagic, N., & Klima, R. Klinik und Therapie der Blutkrankheiten. 2. Aufl. 512p. 8? Berl., 1934. Laltbry, C. Maladies du sang et des organes hematopoietiques. 627p. 8? Par., 1933. Morawitz, P. Blood diseases in clinical prac- tice; transl. from 2nd German ed. by A. Piney. 102p. 8? Lond., 1933. Naegeli, O. Blutkrankheiten und Blut- diagnostik; Lehrbuch der klinischen Hamato- logie. 4. Aufl. 587p. 8? Berl., 1923. Piney, A. Diseases of the blood. 195p. 8? Lond., 1928. Also 2. ed. 310p. 1932. ---- Blood diseases in general practice. 92p. 16? Lond., 1934. ---- & Wyard, S. Clinical atlas of blood diseases. 98p. 8? Lond., 1930. Also 2. ed. 105p. 1932. Also 3. ed. 109p. 1935. Also 4. ed. 127p. 20y>cm. Lond., 1938. Rosenow, G. Blutkrankheiten; eine Darstel- lung fur die Praxis. 260p. 8? Berl., 1925. Schittenhelm, A. Handbuch der Krank- heiten des Blutes und der blutbildenden Organe: Haemophilie, Hsemoglobinurie, H:jematoporphyrie. 2v. 616p.;619p. 4? Berl., 1925. ---- Die Krankheiten des Blutes und der blutbildenden Gewebe. p.240-341. 8? Berl., 1936. In Lehrb. inn. Med, 3. Aufl, Berl, 1936, 2: Also 4. Aufl, 1939, 2: 255-360. Schlecht, H. Blutkrankheiten. 197p. 8! Dresd., 1932. Weil, P. E., Bloch, M., & Vallery-Radot, P. Precis de pathologie medicale: maladies du sang et des organes hematopoietiques; maladies des reins. 628p. 8? Par., 1922. Whitby, L. E. H., & Britton, C. J. C. Disorders of the blood; diagnosis, pathology, treatment and technique. 543p. 8? Lond., 1935. Also 3. ed. 630p. 25cm. Phila. [1939] A. Patologia sanguigna nei 1923. Gazz. osp, 1923, 44: 020 32.—-B. Bhituntersuchung und Blutkrankheiten. Praxis, Hern, 1924, 13: H. 21, 5; 7.—Berghinz, G. Emopatie. Pediat. med. prat. Tor, 1936, 11: 266-81.—Brugsch, H. Blut, Blut- und Blutungskrankheiten. Mschr. Kinderh, 1937, 70: 117-30.—Buckman, T. E. Diseases of the hemolvtopoietic organs. In Pract. I.ibr. M. & S. (Appleton) 1935, 7: 765-92 — Buinevicius, K. [Diseases of the blood and hemopoietic organs] Medicina, Kaunas, 1928, 9: 385; 458. Also Wien med. Wschr, 1940, 90: 959-65.—Eckstein, A. Enfermedades de la sangre. Dia med, B. Air, 1931-32, 4: 613.—Fitz-Hugh, T. Diseases of the blood; a review of modern advances. In- ternat. Clin, 1930, 40. ser, 4: 66-87, 3 pl.—Forkner, C. E. Diseases of the blood-forming organs. Pract. Libr. M. & S (Appleton) N. Y, 1935, 8: 909-58.—Giffin, H. Z. Clinicai lecture on diseases of the blood. Ann. Clin. M, 1922, 1: 151-4. ------ Recent progress in our knowledge of diseases of the blood. Tr. Ass. Physicians Mayo Clin. (1925) 1926, 6: 309-11.—Griffith, J. P. C. Clinical studies of some diseases of the blood in children; with illustrative cases. Tr Am Pediat. Soc. 1024, 36: 22-4. Also Arch. Pediat, N. Y, 1924 41: 511-28.—Grober, J. Die Blutkrankheiten. In Handb' arztl. Krfahr. Weltkrieg, 1921, 3: 622-37.—Harvier, P., & Bernard, J. Les maladies du sang en 1933. Paris med, 1933 89: 105; 1935, 97: 197.- Hill, I- W. A review of the literature on the blood and blood diseases of infants and children for the last 4 years (101S-21) Am. J. Dis. Child.. 1023, 25: 168-83.— Isaacs, R. Progress in diseases of the blood-forming organs In Pract. Libr. M. & H. (Appleton) N. Y, 1038. Suppl, 436- 43.—Kahn, M. H. Diseases of the blood and lymph idanrls Med. Rev. of Rev- 1930, 36: 53-73. Kaplan, A. W, FryHZJ man, W, & Kramarz. J. (Diseases of the. blood] Warsz czas. lek, 1935, 12: 449; 171- Leconte, M. La pathologic sanguine en 1922. Paris med,_ 1922, 45: 27-31.-----4 Yacoel, J. La pathologie sanguine en 1923. Ibid, 1923, 49; 31; 1924, 53: 217.—Lehndorff, H. Reaktionen und Krank- heiten der blutbereitenden Organe ■ im Kindesalter. Mitt Volksgesundhamt, 1932, 12; 46.—Lucas, W. P., & Washburn, A. H. Diseases of the blood and blood-building organs. In Clin. Pediat, N. Y, 1930, 21: 372-85.—Macciotta, G. Ma- lattie del sangue e degli organi ematopoietici. Manuale pediat. (Frontali, G.) Tor, 1936, 2: 1-76.—Malattie del sangue; alcuni contributi recenti. Morgagni, 1924, 66: 577- 83.—Morawitz, P., & Brugsch, H. Blutkrankheiten. Klin. Fortbild, 1933, 1: 1-40, pl. Also in Neue deut. Klinik, 1933, 11: 1-40.—Naegeli, O. Krankheiten des Blutes untl der Drusen mit innerer Sekretion. Diagn. ther. Irrtiim, 1923, H. 10, Inn. Med, 1-68.—Pangaro, J. A. Fisiopatologia de los organos hematopoyeticos. hemocitopoyesis. Dia med, B. Air, 1937, 9: 607-70.—Piney, A. Blood diseases in general practice. Med. Press & Circ, Lond, 1936, 192: 346-50.— Poynton, F. J, Thursfield, H, & Paterson, D. The severe blood diseases of childhood; a series of observations from the Hospital for Sick Children, Great Ormond Street. Brit. J. Child. Dis, 1922, 19: 57; 128.—Schilling, V. Blutlehre und Blutkrankheiten in der Unfallmedizin. In Handb. ges. Un- fallh. (F. Konig & G. Magnus) Stuttg, 1934, 4: 749-807 — Sturgis, C. C. Review of some of the more recent advances in the study of blood diseases. Science, 1035, 81: 367-71. Also repr.—Thursfield, H. Discussion on blood diseases in children. Brit. M. J, 1921, 2: 873-6.-----r Diseases of the haemopoietic and lymphatic systems. In Dis. Child. (Thurs- field & Paterson) Lond, 1934, 482-530. ------ & Paterson, D, Poynton, F. J. The severe blood diseases of childhood; a series of observations from the Hospital for Sick Children, Great Ormond Street. Brit. J. Child. Dis, 1922, 19: 58; 128; 178.—Vinogradov, V. V. [Diseases of the blood and of the blood-forming organs] Klin, med, Moskva, 1928, 6: 190-2.— Whitby, L. E. H. Diseases of the blood-forming organs. In Brit. Encycl. M. Pract. (Rolleston, H.) 1939, Surveys, 52; 1941, Surveys, 1940, 31.—Wilkinson, J. F. Diseases of the blood-forming organs. Practitioner, Lond, 1936, 137: 453-66. ---- Disease: Classification. Arneth. Die Erkrankungen des Blutes und ihre Einteilung nach Blutzellenreaktionen, speziell die lymphatische Reaktion. Munch, med. Wschr, 1925, 72: 423.—Detre, L. [System of myelogenous blood diseases] Gyogy&szat, 1936, 76: 193; passim.—Lifschitz, M. J. Zur Frage nach der Klassifikation und dem Wesen der Systemerkrankungen der lymphoiden, myeloidcn und retikuloendothclialen Gewebe. Fol. haemat, Lpz, 1929, 39: 35-57.—Pittaluga, G. Clasificaci6n de las enfermedades de la sangre. An. Acad, med, Madr, 1916, 36: 398-407 [Discussion] 423-7. Also Siglo med, 1916, 63: 498-501.—Schultz, W. Einteilung der die Blutbildung be- treffenden Krankheiten. Zschr. arztl. Fortbild, 1936, 33: 661-4.—Ward, G. The classification of blood diseases in childhood. Brit. J. Child. Dis, 1923, 20: 84-8. ---- Disease: Diagnosis. See also subheading Examination; also Blood picture; Bone marrow, Examination; Spleen, Examination, &c. Ordway, T., & Gorham, L. W. The diagnosis and treatment of diseases of the blood. 605p. 8? N. Y. [1930] Dardinski, V. J. Hematologic interpretation in general practice. Med. Ann. District of Columbia, 1938, 7: 392-5.— Diagnosi delle malattie acute del sangue. Morgagni, 1923, 65: pt 2, 209-14.—Gloor, H. II. Die Fruhdiagnose der Blut- krankheiten. Deut. med. Wschr., 1935, 61: 455; 541. Also In Samml. wicht. Fruhdiagn, Lpz, 1936, 268-88.—Griin, R. Neurologische Fehldiagnosen bei malignen Blut- und Ge- fasserkrankungen. Zschr. ges. Neur. Psychiat, 1930, 129: 201-8.—Haden, R. L. The diagnosis of the blood dyscrasias in rlnldren. Med. Clin. N. America, 1935-36, 19: 1967-75.— Ham man, L. Problems in hematological diagnosis. Kentucky M. I . 1941, 39: 295-303.— Held, I. W, & Goldbloom, A. A. lundamental principles governing the clinical interpretation of hematologic diseases. Med. Clin. N. America, 1928, 12: 713-80.—Jones, H. W. Points of interest in the diagnosis and treatment of the more common diseases of the blood. Ther. Gaz, Detr, 1924, 3. sei, 40: 849-55.—Karavanov, G. G, & Chernevich, E. L. [Valeur diagnostique de l'examen de la moelle osseuse dans les affections hemopoletiques] Med. exp, Kharkov, 1937, No. 8, 171-90.—Knighton, J. E, jr. Diagnosis in blood dyscrasias. Tristate M. J, 1036-37, 9: 1766; 1777.— Levy, L, & Lowinger, S. A ver-, illetoleg a verkepzo szervek betegsegeinek elkiilonito k6rismezese. In Klin, diagn. (V. Muller) Budap, 1937, 1: 205-30.—Niigeli. Die Diagnose del HEMATOPOIETIC 477 HEMATOPOIETIC akut einsetzenden Blutkrankheiten. Jahrkurs. arztl. Fortbild, 1923 14- H 3. 18-22.—Perles, S. La ponction de la rate dans'les maladies du sang. Paris med 1935, 97: 217-23.— Piltaluea G Diagn6stico y clasificacion de las hemopatias. Clin mod, Zaragoza, 1918, 17: 353-68.—Reuben, M. S. Differential diagnosis of diseases of the hematopoietic system. Arch Pediat, N. Y, 1926, 43: 15-19.—Robertson, W. E. Blood dyscrasias including the Schilling count, with special reference to the specialties in medicine. Proc. Interst. Post- grad. M. Ass. N. America, 1933, 52-6.—Scott, R. B. Sternal puncture in the diagnosis of diseases of the blood-forming organs. Q J. Med, Oxf, 1939, 8: 127-71, 3 pl.—Weiss, A. A simple differential diagnostic procedure in diseases of the hemato- poietic system. J. Lab. Clin. M, 1928-29, 14: 965-7.— Young, R. H, & Osgood, E. E. Sternal marrow aspirated during'life; cytology in health and in disease. Arch. Int. M, 1935,°55: 186-203.—Zanaty, A. F. Tupfpraparate und ihre Anwendung zur Diagnosenstellung der Blutkrankheiten im Sektionssaal. Virchows Arch, 1934, 293: 335-41. ---- Disease: Etiology. For secondary reactions see under names of primary diseases. Ferri, J. Contribution a l'etude du terrain en hematologic; l'avitaminose C, facteur de revelation du desequilibre des centres hema- topoietiques chez les sujets vaccinas a l'anatoxine diphterique. 80p. 25cm. Lyon, 1938. Opitz, H. Die Blutkrankheiten des Kindes- alters. 74p. 8? Berl., 1928. Also Kinderarztl. Prax, 1935, 6: Schilling, V. Blut und Erbe; iiber die Eigen- schaften des Blutes, seine Aufgaben im mensch- lichen Korper und iiber seine Rolle als Ver- erbungstrager mit Einschluss der erblichen Blutkrankheiten. 94p. 8? Hamb. [1936] Cancer-like disease of blood follows Mendelian law. Science News Lett, 1936, 30: 101.—Castronuovo, G. Profili ed orientamenti nell'ematologia tropicale. Gior. ital. mal. esot, 1930, 3: 3; 31; 59; 115.—Dellepiane, G. Contributo alia conoscenza delle anomalie dell'emopoiesi nella vita fetale. Ginecologia, Tor, 1935, 1: 1145-83, 2 pl.—Fischer, M. Der Begriff der erblichen Belastung am Beispiel der Bluterkrankheit. Oeff. Gesundhdienst, 1935, 1: B, 504-9.—Friedemann, U, & Elkeles, A. Studies on the aetiology of blood diseases; a pathogenic agent in normal human bone marrow. Brit. M. J, 1933, 1: 1110-2.-—Gaeta, R. Rilievi eziologici e clinici sulle emopatie. Gazz. osp, 1928, 49: 945-8.—Hirschfeld, H. Blutkrankheiten und Geschwulste. Zschr. Krebsforsch, 1922- 23, 19: 269-81. ------ Blutkrankheiten und Konstitution. Klin. Fortbild, 1935, 3: 494-535—HoflT, F. Blutpathologie und Magensekretion sowie ihre erbpathologischen Beziehungen. Miinch. med. Wschr, 1935, 82: 531; 580.—Honecker, L. Die erbbiologische und praktische Bedeutung der fetalen Blut- krankheiten. Arch. Gyn, Berl, 1934, 157: 604-15.— Kindler, W. Blutsvstemerkrankungen nach Infektionen im Ohren-, Nasen-Halsgebiet. Zschr. Laryng, 1933, 24: 39-45.—Lehn- dorff, H. Reaktionen und Krankheiten der blutbereitenden Organe im Kindesalter. Wien. klin. Wschr, 1931, 44: 1013; 1055. Also Aerztl. Prax, Wien, 1932, 6: 12; 46.—Lenz, F. Die Frage des Erbgangs der Bluterkrankheit und ihr experi- mentum crucis. Deut. Zschr. Chir, 1923, 182: 284-6 — Lescher, F. G, & Hubble, D. A correlation of certain blood- diseases on the hypothesis of bone-marrow deficiency or hypo- plasia. Q. J. Med, Oxf, 1032, n. ser, 1: 425-55.—Matthes, H. G. Beitrag zur Aetiologie und Verlauf der Panmyelophthise. Deut. Arch. klin. Med, 1937, 180: 68-87.—Morris, L. M, & Falconer, E. H. Familial blood dyscrasias. Arch. Int. M, 1924, 34: 757-77. Also repr.—Naegeli. Blutkrankheiten als Konstitutions- und Erbkrankheiten. Med. Welt, 1934, 8: 465-7.—Ohga, T., Jo, S., & Fujii, Y. [Einfliisse der mahgnen Geschwulste auf die hamatopoetischen Organe: Einfluss der malignen Geschwulste auf die Genesung von der kunstlichen Anamie] Taiwan igakkai zasshi, 1941, 40: 1238-55.—Pirie, G. R. Some observations on blood conditions in infancy. Tr. Canad. Soc. Dis. Child, 1924, 2: 34-43.—Pittaluga, G. Las hemodistrofias y las leyes mendelianas. Siglo med, 1920, 67: 798; 818. ------ La herencia mendeliana en la constitution de las hemodistrofias. Progr. clin, Madr, 1926, 34: No. 4, 1, portr.—Rede], D. Die bosartigen Geschwulste und das blutbildende System. Arch. Verdauungskr, 1936, 60: 16-50.— Rolleston, H. The hereditary factor in some diseases of the haemopoietic system. Bull. Johns Hopkins Hosp, 1928, 43: 61-80. Also repr.—Rupilius, K. Ein Beitrag zu den Blutkrank- heiten im Kindesalter. Jahrb. Kinderh, 1934, 3. F, 93:65-99 — Sanchez Yllades, L. Alteraciones bem&ticas en las diferentes afecciones. Medicina, Mex, 1941, 21: 395-406.—Schachter, M. Pathologie hereditaire et maladies du sang. Gaz. hop, 1935, 108: 816.—Schulten, H. Beziehungen zwischen Er- krankungen der Verdauungsorgane und der Blutbildung. Zschr. arztl. Fortbild, 1937, 34: 312-5.—Schultz, W. Blut- krankheiten und Krebs. In Neuere Erg. Krebskrankh, Lpz, 1937, 351-6.—Seiler, J. Zur Frage der reaktiven Blutkrank- heiten. Deut. Arch. klin. Med, 1934-35, 177: 170-201 — Sharp, E. A., & Mack, H. C. The relationship of hemopoietic phenomena to endocrine disorders in women. Endocrinology 1939, 24: 202-18.—Simmel, H. Blutkrankheiten und Kon- stitution. Miinch. med. Wschr, 1924, 71: 1189-91.—Stein- berg, M. Neuropathodynamics and the hemic system. Med Rec, N. Y, 1935, 142: 134.—Stettner, E. Ueber Blutkrank- heiten im Kindesalter; physiologische Vorbemerkungen, allgemeine Aetiologie, allgemeine Pathogenese. Deut. med Wschr, 1925, 51: 554-7. ------■ Ueber Blutkrankheiten im Kindesalter; erbliche Blutschaden. Ibid, 1926, 52: 1223; 1304.—Stransky, E. Neue Ergebnisse der klinischen Hama- tologie im Kindesalter. Mschr. Kinderh, 1931, 50: 257; 428.— Szasz, A, & Gardos, S. Ueber die Ursachen und iiber einige Falle von Erkrankungen des blutbildenden Systems. Ibid, 1937, 70: 105-12.—Talbot, F. B. The blood and blood diseases of infancy and childhood. In Nelson Loose-Leaf Med, N. Y 1920, 4: 60-5— Weil, P. E, & Pollet, L. Le sol hematique; considerations generales sur les maladies famihales du sang. Sang, Par, 1927, 1: 307-12.—Wintrobe, M. M, Matthews,. E. [et al.] A familial hemopoietic disorder in Italian adolescents and adults, resembling Mediterranean disease (thalassemia) J. Am. M. Ass, 1940, 114: 1530-8 —Witts, L. J. The con- stitutional factor in diseases of the blood. Practitioner, Lond, 1932, 129: 450. ------ Hereditary diseases of the blood. In Chances of Morbid Inherit. (Blacker, C. P.) Lond, 1934, 224-45. ---- Disease: Manifestations. Gekker, I. V. [Affections of the hemopoietic organs and their manifestations in the oral cavity] 36p. 17#cm. Rostov, 1935. Sieber, T. *TJeber cerebrale Herdsymptome bei Blutkrankheiten. 40p. 8? Erlangen, 1931. Arzt, L. Hautorgan und Blutkrankheiten. Wien. med. Wschr, 1930, 86: 201; 231.—Barney, J. D, Hunter, F. T., & Mintz, E. R. The urologic aspects of radio-sensitive tumors of the blood-forming organs. J. Am. M. Ass., 1932, 98: 1245- 50.—Bourret, M. De l'importance de certaines manifestations cutanees d'aspect banal, comme signes avertisseurs des etats pathologiques du systeme hematopoietique. Marseille med, 1929, 66: pt 1, 753-66.—Brown, C. P, & Shea, I. P. Basal metabolism and hematology. Week. Roster, Phila, 1938-39, 34: 563-7.—Bykowa, O. Veranderungen im weissen Blutbilde infolge krankhafter Veranderungen der blutbildenden Organe. Fol. haemat, Lpz, 1930, 41: 415-27. ------ Veranderungen des Bluts bei einigen organischen Lasionen der blutbereitenden Organe. Ibid, 1931-32, 46: 250-5.—Coston, T. O. The ocular manifestations of blood diseases. Internat. Clin, 1935, 45. ser, 3: 252-65.—Crouzon. A propos de la communication de M. Dereux (syndrome neuro-anemique avec atrophie optique; echec du traitement par la methode de Whipple) Bull. Soc. med. hop. Paris, 1929, 3. ser, 53: 633.—Fontana, L. Malattie del sangue; semiologia e diagnostica generale. In Med. int. (Ceconi) Tor, 1932, 3: 455-530.—Gans, O. The skin picture of hematopoietic disease. Proc. Mayo Clin, 1927, 2: Suppl, 202-4. Also Arch. Derm. Syph, Chic, 1927, 16: 1-7.—Gavazzeni, M, & Borghetti, U. Sistema nervoso centrale e crasi ematica. Boll. Soc. med. chir, Pavia, 1934, 48: 941-4.— Hefter, L. I. [Significance of clinical syndromes and transitory forms of diseases in hematology] Klin, med, Moskva, 1940, 18: No. 11, 44-9.—Hegler, C. Fruhsymptome und ihre praktische Bedeutung; Blutkrankheiten. Med. Welt, 1934, 8- 12- 48.—Horsters, H. Blutkrankheiten und Blutzucker. Zschr. ges. exp. Med, 1935-36, 97: 463-72.—Ianovsky, D. N. [Hematopoiesis and diseases of the hematopoietic organs] Tr. Ukrain. sezd. terapevtov (1936) 1939, 4. Congr, 296- 308.—Jiirgensen, E. Vergleichende Mikrocapillar- und Hautsekretionsbeobachtungen bei Blutkrankheiten. Deut. Arch. klin. Med, 1931, 172: 233-47.—Keschner, M. Neuro- psychiatric complications in diseases of the blood. Internat. Clin, 1923, 33. ser, 1: 91-112.—Kyrieleis, W. Ueber Augen- hintergrundsveriinderungen bei Blutkrankheiten. Zschr. Augenh, 1933, 82: 15-30.—Lamb, F. H. Hemopoietic diseases and the nervous system. J. Iowa M. Soc, 1935, 25: 340-2.— Lawson, A, Tidy, H. L. [et al.] Diseases of the blood and their ophthalmologic complications. Arch. Ophth, Chic, 1935, 14: 166.—Leiner, J. H. Nervous and mental symptoms in diseases of the blood (from a studv of 141 cases) N. York State J. M, 1928 28: 1047-50.—Martelli, C. Gli stati pre-emopatici clinici e sperimentali. Riiiasc. med, 1930, 7: 207.—Mathieu, P Syndromes neuroanemiques et troubles digestifs. Arch. mal. app. digest. Par, 1926, 16: 536-51. ---—• Etude clinique des syndromes neuro-anemiques. Prat. med. tr, 192b, 5- 218 —Mayo W. J. The relation of splenic syndrome to the patholosry of the blood. J. Iowa M. Soc, 1922, 12: 243-8.— Mikhailov, A. A. [Sensitiveness of bones in affections of the hematopoietic system] Klin, mod, Moskva, 1938, 16: 1683- 5 —Nanta, A. Dermatoses en rapport avec les troubles de I'appareil hematopoietique (hematodermies) In Nouv. prat. derm. (Darier, Sabouraud [et al.]) Par, 1936 5: 521-664 — Pedro y Pons, A. Contribucion al estudio de las alteraciones nerviosas en las enfermedades de la sangre (sindromes neuro- hem&ticos) Rev. med. Barcelona, 1930, 13: 483-511.— Pruvost, P. L'hematologie dans les maladies du sang. J. med chir. Par, 1920, 91: 5-22.—Rolleston, H, Andrewes, F. HEMATOPOIETIC 478 HEMATOPOIETIC [et al.] Discussion on disorders of the blood and their ophthal- mological manifestations. Tr. Ophth. Soc. U. K, 1923, 43: 110-08, 2 pl.—Sassier & Houzeau. Les maladies du sang et leurs manifestations buccales. Presse med, 1934, 42: 1773. Also Rev. stomat. Par., 1034. 36: 746-50.—Storti, E, & De Filippi, P. II potere radiantu del sangue e dei tessuti di alcune forme emopatiche sistemiche. Radiobiologia, Venez, 1935-36, 4: No. 4, 49-66. Also Riforma med, 1936, 52: 639-11 — Strauss, S. Diseases of the blood, with special reference to hemorrhages. Med. Clin. N. America, 1926, 9: 1563-76.— Szalay, F. [Changes in the nervous system due to diseases of the hematopoietic organs] Orv. hetil, 1930, 74: 729-32.—Weber, F. P. Severe blood diseases with pyrexia. Practitioner, Lond, 1929. 123: 171-9. ---- Disease: Pathology. See also proper names of diseases as Anemia; Erythroblastosis; Granuloma malignum, &c. Elkoff, P. *Die Haufigkeit der perniciosen Anamie und der Leukamien wahrend der letzten 17 Jahre auf Grund der Krankheitsfalle der beiden medizinischen Kliniken in Munchen. 32p. 8? Munch., 1927. P6voa, H. Sangue e metabolismo. 312p. 23y2em. Rio, 1940. Reimann, M. *Ueber anatomische Grund- lagen multipler Blutdriisenerkrankungen. 50p. 8! Miinch. [1935] Alperin, P. M., & Iosikova, V. M. [Vitamin C metabolism in hematological diseases] Ter. arkh, 1941, 19: 227-35.— Altnow, H. O. The diseases of the blood (a grouping with reference to the changes occurring in the blood formative tissues) J. Lancet, 1932, 52: 271; 706.—Bayon, H. P. Discussion on the pathology and treatment of haemopathies, including leukae- mias, of man and animals; the haemopathies of laboratory animals. Proc. R. Soc. M, Lond, 1931, 24: 1141-56, 2 pl.— Becher, E. Neue chemische Blutbefunde bei Blutkrankheiten. Zbl. inn. Med, 1926, 47: 350-2.—Borchardt, H. Ueber nor- male und pathologische Histologic und Funktion des blut- bildenden Gewebes (unter Ausschluss der Milz) Fol. haemat, Lpz, 1(»29, 38: 109-18.—Bull, L. B, & Cleland, J. B. Some considerations on the anaemias, leuchaemias, leucosarcoma and allied conditions. Med. J. Australia, 1927, 2: Suppl, 196- 201.—Bykowa, O. Ueber die Veranderungen der blutbildenden Organe unter der Einwirkung einiger Bakterien und Toxine (experimentelle Untersuchungen) Virchows Arch, 1927, 265: 226-38.—Ciminata, A. Contributo alia fisiopatologia dell'apparato linfatico-ematopoietico. Policlinico, 1922, 29: sez. med, 319-30.—Dentici, S. Gli organi emopoietici nella biologiadei tumori. Haematologica, Pavia, 1930, 1: 161-70.— Doan, C. A, & Reinhart, H. L. The basophil granulocyte, basophilocytosis, and myeloid leukemia, basophil and mixed granule types; an experimental, clinical and pathological study, with the report of a new syndrome. Am. J. Clin. Path, 1941, 11: 1-39.—Ekelov, M. M, & Alymov, A. Y. [Pernicious anemia and leukemia] Vrach. delo, 1928. 11: 1925-7.—Essbach, H. Ueber das Auftreten von Riesenzellen bei Systemerkrankungen des hiimatopoetischen Apparates. Virchows Arch, 1938-39 303: 706-28.—Fahr, T. Beitrage zur Pathologie des Knochen- markes und der Blutbildung und Hamoglobinstoffwechsel zusammenhangenden Vorgange. Ibid, 1930, 275: 288-304.— Fassrainer, S. Lipoidgranulomatose des hamatopoetischen Systems. Beitr. path. Anat, 1934, 94: 153-62.—Fontana, L. Contributo alio studio delle cellule istioidi cireolanti in varie emopatie. Haematologica, Pavia, 1926, 7: 97-136, 3 pl.— Forkner, C. E. An attempt to consolidate and to clarify present views concerning the anemias and the hemorrhagic disorders. Abstr. Proc. Ass. Life Insur. M. Dir. America 1938, 25: 258-82.—Francke, E. Beitrag zur Frage der toxi- schen Zellschadigung bei Panmyelopathien an Hand von Versuchen in vitro und von bioptischen Markbefunden. Zschr. ges. exp. Med, 1938, 104: 405-64.—Gardos, S. Selte- nere Erkrankungen des blutbildenden Systems. Mschr Kinderh, 1939-40, 81: 115-23.—Herman, K. [Multiple sclerosis of the hematopoietic organs] Gy6gy£szat, 1931, 7: 533-5.—HofT, F. Beitrage zur Pathologie der Blutkrankheiten! \irchows Arch, 1926, 261: 142-89.—JagiC, N. Reaktionen in den Blutbildungsstatten bei Infektionen. Wien. klin Wschr, 1926, 39: 1409-14. ------ Schadigung und Reaktion in den Blutbildungstatten. Wien. med. Wschr, 1926, 76- 1398-401.—Jeney, A. von. Ueber die Wirkung der kunst^ lichen Gallestauung auf die Blutbildungsorgane bei Kaninchen Zschr. ges. exp. Med, 1928, 60: 102-15.—Kaiser, O. Ueber den Einfluss temporiirer Einschrankung des blutbereitenden Gewebes durch Gefassabklemmung. Ibid, 1930, 72: 211-27.__ Klemperer, P. The relationship of the reticulum to diseases of the hematopoietic system. In Contr. Med. Sc. (E. Lebman) N. \, 1932, 2: 655-71.—Kranspe. Seltenere pathologisch- anatomische Befunde bei Erkrankungen des blutbildenden Apparates. Zbl. allg. Path, 1938, 70: 556—Kukoverov, A. V [Katalase of sternal puncture and peripheral blood in affections of the hematopoietic organs] Klin, med, Moskva, 1938 16- 1686-91.—Langen, C. D. de. Studies on blood diseases' and blood regeneration in Java. Proc. R. Soc M, Lond, 1933, 28: Trop. Dis, 37—46.—Lignac, G. O. K. [A conception of the particular pathology of the hemopoietic organs] Ned. tsohr geneesk, 1936, 80: 3538-45.—McLean, J. A. Supravital staining of the large mononuclear cells in infectious mono- nucleosis and the acute leuchemias, with particular reference to their origin in the former disease. Med. J. Australia 1929 2: 734-40, 2 pl.—Martelli, C. Gli stati pre-emopatici. Rinasc' med, 1925, 2: 273-6, pl.—Minot, G. R. Purpura hemorrhagica (thrombopenic purpura) leukemia and erythemia. Boston M. & S. J, 1925, 192: 14-6.—Musser, J. H. Alterations and changes in various types of blood diseases. Proc. Interst Postgrad. M. Ass. N. America (1930) 1931, 6: 384-8.—Nagelij O. Die Milz in ihren Beziehungen zu Bluterkrankungen' Jahrkurs. firztl. Fortbild, 1921, 12: H. 3, 30-5.—Neuborgerj J, & Plenge, K. Zur Frage der gleichzeitigen Beteiligung alter drei Systeme bei Erkrankungen des hamatopoetischen Ap- parates. Deut. Arch. klin. Med, 1930, 166: 32-42.—Nob6- court, P. [Diseases of the blood, cerebrospinal fluid and nucleated lymphocytes] Ucheb. detsk. bolez, 1928, 3: 495- 523.—Oesterlin, E. Ein Fall kombinierter Knochen-Bluter- krankung. Virchows Arch, 1923-24, 247: 589-98.—Paviot, J, & Levrat, M. Cancer secondaire des organes hematopoie- tiques avec myeiemie. Sang, Par, 1934, 8: 415-21.—Pittaluga G. Las hemodistrofias y la patologia infantil. Siglo med.' 1918, 65: 939; 956. ------ Hemopatias y sistema reticule^ endotelial. Dia med. urug, 1936, 3: 609; 630.—Poynton, F. J. The heart in the severe blood diseases of childhood. Practi- tioner, Lond, 1922, 109: 79-88.—Rakochi. G. A. [Atypic affections of the hematopoietic apparatus] Vrach. delo, 1939, 21: 545-50.—Redlich, F. [Difference between diseases of the blood and diseases of the circulatory apparatus] Polska gaz lek, 1930, 9: 945-9.—Reichel, J. Beitrage zur Kenntnis der perniziosen Anamie und der akuten Leukamien. Wien Arch inn. Med, 1929, 19: 241-72.—Ribierre, P. Sur quelques acquisitions recentes d'interfit pratique en pathologie cardio- vasculaire renale et hematique. Medecine, Par, 1922-23, 4: 405-13.—Riccitelli, L. Coexistence ou succession de plusieura hemopathies sur le meme sujet. Sang, Par, 1934, 8: 237-68, pl. ------ Ricerche anatomo-cliniche su alcune emopatie. Diag- nosi, 1930, 10: 21-6, pl.—Ruffmann, E. Ueber kombinierte Storungen des endokrinen Systems und des blutbildenden Gewebes mit besonderer Berucksichtigung einer klinisch- anatomischen Beobachtung nebst kurzer Uebersicht iiber die Bluterkrankungen der Jahre 1926 bis Marz 1937, im Sektions- material des Pathologischen Instituts der Universitat Konigs- berg (Pr.) Frankf. Zschr. Path, 1938, 52: 329-45.—Sasybin, N. Histopathologische Veranderungen der blutbildenden Organe bei Einwirkung hoher Temperatur. Virchows Arch, 1934, 292: 114-28— Schmahl, P. J. R. On the classification of the anemias and other disorders affecting the hemopoietic system. Bull. N. York M. Coll, 1938, 1: 76-82.—Seiler, J., & Heisler, W. Zwei atypische Falle von Blutkrankheiten. Munch, med. Wschr, 1935, 82: 577-80.—Steinbrinck, W. Weitere Beitrage zur Pathologie der Blutkrankheiten. Deut. med. Wschr, 1925, 51: 1824; 1870.—Sternberg, C. Einige neuere Begriffe und Termini aus der Pathologie der Erkran- kungen des blutbildenden Apparates. Wien. med. Wschr., 1925, 75: 2609.—Szajna, M. [Two cases of rare diseases of the blood] Polska gaz. lek, 1932, 11: 55-6.—Williams, F. F, jr. The spleen and its relation to blood diseases. In Surg. Spleen (Fobes, J. H.) Lancaster, 1917, 27-30.—Zanaty, A. F. Die Blutkrankheiten des Sektionsmaterials der letzten 11 Jahre des Pathologischen Instituts der Universitat Berlin (Charite- Krankenhaus) nebst Anfiihrung einiger bemerkenswerter Falle. Virchows Arch, 1934-35, 294: 315-28. ---- Disease: Surgery. See also Splenectomy, &c. Bryzman, H. *Ueber die Exstirpation der Milz bei Blutkrankheiten. 25p. 8? Berl., 1919. Acufia, M. Valor e indicaciones de la esplenectomia en las enfermedades de la sangre en la infancia. Arch, argent, pediat, 1934, 5: 629; 701.—Aiga, Y. Ueber Unterbindung der Milige- fasse als Ersatz fiir Splenektomie bei Blutkrankheiten; experi- mentelle Untersuchung. Zbl. Chir, 1935, 62: 2301-4.— Boettiger, C. Surgical aids in the treatment of blood dys- crasias. Med. Times, N. Y, 1934, 62: 180.—Cazin, M. Traite- ment chirurgical des maladies du sang. Rev. techn. chir. Par, 1932, 24: 217-24.—Feierman, I. L. [Surgery of the hemato- ?01xt1C tsysteml Klin- med-, Moskva, 1932, 10: 18.—Gamin, J. N., & Good, R. W. The diagnosis of certain blood dys- crasias and their treatment by splenectomy. J. Med, Cincin, 1934, 15: 407-12.—Gregoire, R., & Santy, P. Traitement chirurgical des maladies du sang. P. verb. Congr. fr. chir, 1932, 41: 393-479. Also J. chir. Par, 1932, 40: 526-45.- Hanrahan, E. M. Splenic blood disorders; a surgical classifica- tion with reference to splenectomy. Ann. Surg, 1925, 181: 906-10.—Mills, E. S. Blood dyscrasias amenable to treatment by splenectomy. Canad. M. Ass. J, 1935, 33: 480.—Ranzl, j &.ATancini' L- p- Ton- Indikationsstellung und Resultate der Milzexstirpation bei Bluterkrankungen. Wien. klin. Wschr, 1935, 48: 637-44.—Sinclair, T. The surgery of the blood. Brit. M. J, 1922, 1: 375-7.—Vogel, R. Milzexstirpa- S?11,^61 Blutkrankheiten. Deut. Zschr. Chir., 1923, 180: 37-106. HEMATOPOIETIC 479 HEMATOPOIETIC --- Disease: Treatment. Jagi6, N. von, & Spengler, G. Klinik und Therapie der Blutkrankheiten. 311p. 8? Berl., Wien, 1928. Also 2. Aufl. 512p. 1934. Milano. Istittjto sieroterapico Milanese. Cenni di opoterapia ed immunoterapia delle malattie del sangue e del ricambio. 47p. 8? Milano, 1932. Wright, I. S. Treatment of diseases of blood and lymph vessels, p.521-92. 25cm. N. Y., 1941. Brsottelli, A. Las vitaminas y el calcio en las hemodistro- fias. Arch, med, Madr, 1928, 29: 624-30.—Decastello, A. Empirik und Theorie der modernen Behandlungsmethoden bei Erkrankungen des hamatopoetischen Systems. Med. Klin, Berl, 1931, 27: 907-11.—De Stella, H. Le traitement des maladies du sang. Ann. Soc. med. Gand, 1931, n. ser, 10: 9-19. Also Rev. beige sc. med, 1931, 3: 263-73.—Domarus, A. von. Fortschritte in der Therapie der Blutkrankheiten. Zschr. iirztl. Fortbild, 1932, 29: 381; 420.—Ewald, L. A. Clinical observations on the treatment of chlorosis and anemia and pseudoleukemia. Virginia M. Semi-Month, 1902-3, 7: 57-60.—Goldfiem, A. S. de, & Goldfiem, J. S. de. Remedes des organes hematopoietiques. Rev. med. hyg. trop. Par, 1938, 30: 172-81.—Gualdi, A. II rosso Congo nei trattamento di alcune emopatie. Riv. osp, 1936, 26: 323-34.—Heath, C. W. Treatment of diseases of blood and blood-forming organs. In Treat. Gen. Med, 2. ed, Phila, 1941, 2: 1598-698.— Ischlondsky, N. E. La secretion interne des tissus embryon- naires et la fonction hematopoietique (sur le traitement des anemies et des troubles leucemiques) Progr. med. Par, 1933, 301-9.—Jagi6, N. Behandlung der Blutkrankheiten. Wien. med. Wschr, 1921, 71: 877; 972; 1012. Also Wien. klin. Wschr, 1927, 40: H. 37, Sonderb, 1-8. ------ Neueres in der Therapie der Blutkrankheiten. Ibid, 1930, 43: 1333-6. Also Aerztl. Prax, Wien, 1931, 5: 257-60. ------ A prop6sito del estado actual de la clinica y de la terapeutica de las en- fermedades de la sangre. Med. ibera, 1934, 28: pt 2, 557-9.— Josefson, A. [Liver treatment in certain blood diseases] Sven. lak. tidn, 1930, 27: 942-7.—Konchalovsky, M. P. [Therapeutic significance of blood transfusion in affections of the hemopoietic system] Klin, med, Moskva, 1936, 14: 760-2.—Koranyi, A. V. Benzol in der Therapie von Blut- krankheiten. Fol. med. Nap, 1933, 19:1337-44.—Lindstroem, G. Experiences sur les animaux de traitement par le serum leucolytique; essai de traitement des maladies du sang par un serum spetifique. Arch. mal. coeur, 1921, 14: 145-55.— Madon, V. F. II valore del ricambio emoglobinico per lo studio delle emopatie infantili e dell'azione dell'epatoterapia. Riv. clin. pediat, 1934, 32: 660-75.—Murphy, W. P. Progress in the treatment of some diseases of the blood. Minnesota M, 1936, 19: 73-8. Also in Med. Papers (H. A. Christian Anniv. Vol.) Bost, 1936, 591-9.—Musser, J. H, & Wright, D. O. The treatment of some diseases of the blood. J. Missouri M. Ass, 1934, 31: 261-71.—Nadig, A. Die Behandlung der Blutkrank- heiten in Val Sinestra. Praxis, Bern, 1925, 14: H. 48, 1; 3; H. 49, 1; 3.—Rosenow, G. Seeklimatische Behandlung von Blutkrankheiten. Zschr. wiss. Baderk, 1926-27, 1: 579-88. ----- Allgemeine Therapie der Blutkrankheiten. Zschr. arztl. Fortbild, 1927, 24: 525-32.—Roth, T. Zur Therapie der Panmyelophthise. Deut. med. Wschr, 1938, 64: 1728 — Savy, P. Traitement des maladies du sang et des organes hematopoietiques. In his Ther. clin. Par, 1936, 2: 801-974.— Schlecht, H. Diiitbehandlung der Blutkrankheiten. Fortsch. Ther, 1932, 8: 513.—Singer, K. Zur Dauerbehandlung und Befiirsorgung haematologischer Krankheitszustande. Wien. klin. Wschr, 1932, 45: 1349.— Smelf, R. F. [Progress in diagnosis and treatment of diseases of the blood during 1930] Cas. iek. cesk., 1931, 70: 495; 531.—Treutlein, A. Bad Kissin- gen und seine Heilmittel fur Blutkrankheiten (Malaria, Bleich- sucht, etc.) Munch, med. Wschr, 1922, 69: 628.—Vlados, K. K. [Therapeutic achievements in hematology] Sovet. klin, 1934, 20: 934-45.—Walterhofer. Die physikalische Behand- lung der Blutkrankheiten und ihre Grundlagen. Zschr. ges. phys. Ther, 1923, 27: 90-102.—Witts, L. J. Recent advances in the treatment of blood diseases. Practitioner, Lond, 1934, 133: 426-33. --- Disease: Treatment: Radiotherapy. Bathe, O. G. K. *Die Behandlung von Blutkrankheiten mit radioaktiven Substanzen. 35p. 8? Kiel, 1914. Arzt, L. Ueber die Technik der Radiumbehandlung bei Blutkrankheiten. Wien. klin. Wschr, 1930, 43: 708.—Attilj, S. La rontgenterapia delle emopatie. Riv. osp, 1934, 24: 110- 25.—Bardachzi, F. Die Rontgenstrahlenbehandlung der Blutkrankheiten. Klin. Fortbild, 1937-38, 5: 683-701.— Beclere, H. La radiotherapie des affections du sang. J. med. fr, 1921, 10: 99-105.—Bignami, G. Die Radiotherapie der Blutkrankheiten. Strahlentherapie, 1932, • 43: 43-67.— Dautwitz, F. Die Radiumbestrahlung bei Erkrankungen der Blutbildungsstatten. Wien. klin. Wschr, 1928, 41: 62-4 — Duelling, J., Marques, P., & Miletzky, O. Radiotherapie totale dans les maladies des organes hematopoietiques; modifi- ?^17no,SanogcUnmls e£ deductions pratiques. J. radiol. electr, 19^7, 21: 250-7—Ferrata, A. Emopatie e raggi Roentgen. Riforma med, 1930, 46: 835-8 -Grosglik, A. Zwei bemerS: werte Falle aus dem Gebiet der Blutkrankheiten. Internat. Radiother. Darmst, 1927-28, 3: 1142-50.—Gulland, G. L., & MatcaUe, J. Discussion on radiation in the treatment of dis- eases on the blood. Brit. M. J, 1921, 2: 271-5.—Jagic N & Spengler, G. Radiumtherapie bei Blutkrankheiten. Verh. Deut. Ges inn Med, 1930, 42. Kongr, 536-8. Also Wien. Win. Wschr, 1930, 43: 705-8.—Kading, K. Die Rontgen- therapie von Blutkrankheiten. Strahlentherapie, 1925-26 21 - ■I~11-—Kupferle, L. Blutkrankheiten und deren Behandlung rrut Rontgenstrahlen. Fortsch. Ther, 1932, 8: 673-80. Also Strahlentherapie, 1933, 47: 179-87.—Milani, E. La roentgen- terapia nelle malattie del sistema emopoietico. Arch, radiol Nap, 1930,. 6: 379-422.—Pape, R. Rontgentherapie der Blutkrankheiten. Wien. klin. Wschr, 1934, 47: 1459. Also Aerztl. Prax, Wien, 1935, 9: 205.—Plaut, H. F. X-ray treat- ment of disorders of the blood and blood forming organs. J. Med, Cincin, 1939-40, 20: 36-9.—Propos (A) de la tehlroent- gentherapie totale dans les maladies du sang et des organes hematopoietiques. Progr. med. Par, 1936, 1004.—Siciliano, L. Commenti e problemi intorno alia radioterapia delle malattie del sangue. Atti Congr. ital. radiol. med, 1930, 315- 4,3-------Zur Radiotherapie der Harhopathien. Strahlen- therapie, 1930, 38: 791.—Steinitz, E. Ueber die Wirkung kleinster und grosserer Rontgendosen bei schweren Blut- krankheiten. Ibid, 1932, 44: 739.—Stern, L. D. Radiation in the treatment of blood diseases. J. Michigan M. Soc, 1922, 21: 324-7.—Taft, A. R, & Taft, R. B. The value of radiology in the treatment of Hodgkins and other blood diseases; with case reports. Med. Rev. of Rev, 1925, 31: 367-71.—Teschen- dorf, W. Ueber Bestrahlungen des ganzen menschlichen Kor- pers bei Blutkrankheiten. Fortsch. Rontgenstrahl, 1927, 36. Kongrh. [Beih.] 71. Also Strahlentherapie, 1927, 26: 720-8 — Turano, L. Contributo alia Roentgen-terapia delle emopatie. Cult. med. mod. Pal, 1930, 9: 401-7.—Wittkowsky, C. Die Rontgentherapie der Blutkrankheiten. Fortsch. Rontgen- strahl, 1926, 34: 739-62.—Zibordi, F. Raggi Rontgen come metodo di saggio nelle emopatie dell'infanzia. Clin, pediat. Mod, 1924, 6: 321-40. ---- Embryology, and growth. See also Blood formation, Theories; Fetus, Blood. Betances, L. M. GenSse des organes hematopoietiques et des cellules du sang des invertebres. C. rend. Acad, sc, 1926, 182: 165-8.—Damberg, S. Ueber die extramedullar Bildung des hamatopoetischen Gewebes. Fol. haemat, Lpz, 1913, 16: 1. Teil, 209-26, 5 pl.—Federici, E. Recherches experimentales sur les potentialites de Pilot sanguin chez l'embryon de Rana fusca. Arch, biol. Par, 1926, 36: 465-87, pl.—Forkner, C. E. A simplified concept of the origin and development of the cells of the blood and blood-forming organs. Chin. M. J, 1937, 51: 619-26.—Gonzalez Guzman, I. Estudio nucleolar de las celulas mesenquimatosas del embri6n de rata gris. Arch. lat. amer. card, Mex, 1937, 7: 134-40, 2 pl.—Hett, J. Ueber Blutbildungsherde im Mesenchym menschlicher Embryonen. Zschr. Zellforsch, 1938, 28: 83-98.—Jordan, H. E. The evolu- tion of blood-forming tissues. Q. Rev. Biol, 1933, 8: 58-76. Also repr. ------ The transformation of adipose tissue into hemocytopoietic tissue. Anat. Rec, 1934, 59: 461-75.— Knoll, W. Einige Befunde im Blute und in den blutbildenden Organen menschlicher Embryonen. Schweiz. med. Wschr, 1925, 55: 632.—Kurihara, M. Embryonale Blutbildung in den bindegewebigen membranosen Gebilden des Menschen und Kaninchens. Fol. haemat, Lpz, 1937, 57: 228-50—Mjas- sojedov, S. W. Genetische Wechselbeziehungen zwischen den Zellformen des lockeren Bindegewebes und des Blutes bei Wirbeltieren. Arch. exp. Zellforsch, 1928, 7: 135-95 — Murray, P. D. F. The development of the blood of the early chick embryo. Proc. R. Soc, Lond, 1932, ser. B, 111: 497, 4 pl.—Rohlich, K. [Myelopoiesis in the lymph nodes of new- born animals] Magy. orv. arch, 1933, 84: 310-20.—Storti, E. Le possibility, citoematogene dell'endotelio dei sacchi linfatici degli anfibi. Boll. Soc. ital. biol. sper, 1931, 6: 1059-62.— Tur, J. Sur un arrangement special d'liots sanguins dans les blastodermes polygeniques des oiseaux. C. rend. Soc. biol, 1929, 100: 256-8. ------ Sur la correlation entre la formation des vaisseaux vitellins et celle des globules sanguins. Bull. internat. Acad, polon. sc, 1933, ser. BII, 3: 43-50. ---- Examination. Bloom, W. Tissue cultures of blood and blood-forming tissues. In Handb. Hemat. (Downey, H.) N. Y, 1938, 2: 1471-585.—Introzzi, P. La biopsia degli organi ematopoietici. In Emopatie, 2. ed. (Feratta) Milano, 1935, 2: pt 3, 1373-538.— Krischbaum, A, & Downey, H. A comparison of some of the methods used in studies of hemopoietic tissues. Anat. Rec, 1937-38, 68: 227-35, 2 pl.—tomovitzky, P. A, & Osnovina- Lomovitzkaya, A. D. [Problem of determining the functions of hematopoietic organs] Izv. Tomsk. Univ., 1926, 78: 94-105.— Petri, S. Die Untersuchungsmethoden der hamatopoetischen Organe. In Handb. allg. Hamat. (Hirschfeld) Berl, 1933, 2: 1. Halfte, 197-228.—Richter, M. N. A modified methylene azure B stain for sections of human hematopoietic organs. HEMATOPOIETIC 480 HEMATOPOIETIC Arch. Path, Chic, 1927, 4: 773-5.—Schustrow, N, & Wlados. Zur Frage der Funktionsprufung der blutbildenden Organe. Zschr. klin. Med, 1921, 92: 495-504.—Vieira de Almeida Ramos, A. Exame funcional do sistema hemo-cito-reparndor. Acta med.. Rio, 1941, 7: 52-74 — Weil, P. E. Les ponction« coupiees de la rate et de la moelle osseuse dans les maladies de Hv.steme des organes hematopoietiques. Haematologica, Pavia, 1937, 18: 1061-8. ---- Explantation. Bloom. W. Ereebnisse der Ziichtungsversuche von Blut und hluthildi-iidcn Organen. In Handb. allg. Hamat. (Hirsch- feld) Pei I, 1932-33. 1: 2. Ilalfte. 1179-228, 8 pl.— Jeney, A. Weitere Heobachtungen an blutbildenden Organen in Gewe- bekulturen. Virchows Arch, 1032-33, 287: 373; passim.— Murray, P. D. F. The cultivation in saline and other media of the haematopoietic region of the early chick embryo. Arch. exp. Zellforsch, 1933, 14: 574-94. ---- Pharmacology. See also Blood formation, Effect of various agents. Bankow, G. Histologische Veranderungen der hamopoe- tkchen Organe, hervorgerufen durch Hamocitrat. Deut. Zschr. Chir., 1931, 233: 630-4— Chatterjee, B. N. The effect of iron on the haemogenic organs. Ind. .1. M. Res, 1928-29, 16: 887-900.—Day, H. G, Stein, H. J, & McCollum, E. V. The effect upon hematopoie.sis of variations in the levels of calcium, phosphorus, and iron in the diet. Proc. Am. Soc. Biol. Chem, 1938, 8: No. 7, 28.—Gingold, N. L'action de l'acide ascorbique (vitamine C) sur I'appareil hematopoietique normal el pathologique (en dehors des etats hemorragiques) Bull. Acad. med. Roumanie, 1936, 1: pt 2, 875-7.—Golden, A, & Silverglade, A. Sensitization of guinea pigs to cyclic com- pounds ami effect on the hematopoietic svstem. Proc. Soc. Exp. Biol, N. V, 1937-38, 37: 400-2.- ludina, N. 1). [Reac- tion of the hemopoietic svstem to various irritants according to age] J. m6d, Kiev, 1937, 7: 1183-91.—Kirkman, N. F. The effect of low-porphyrin diet on erythropoiesis and haemoglobin regeneration. J. Physiol, Lond, 1939, 95: 508-15.—Kokas, E. Ueber die hamolytische und hamopoetische Wirkung von Milz- iiml Knochenmarkextrakten. Arch. ges. Physiol, 1926, 212: 229-38.—Levy, M. I). The effect of drugs on the hemato- poietic system. Texas J. M, 1940-41, 36: 410-5.—Lo Cascio, (J. Azione farmacologia di colloidi di mcrcurio, di piombo, di rame sugli organi emopoietiei. Boll. Soc. ital. biol. sper, 1929, 4: 617-21.—Liihrs, G. J. Leber die Wirksamkeit der gebrauch- lichsten Reizmitlel fiir die blutbildenden Organe. Deut. mod. Wschr, 1921, 47: 564.—Osgood. E. E. The action of benzol- roentgen-rays and radium on the blood and blood-forming organs. Ann. Int. M, 1932, 6: 771-4.—Passalacqua, N. Influenza degli estratti ovarici (follicolina, uteina) mammari, placentari, ipofisari, soprarenali, sugli organi ematopoietici e sul sangue. Monit. ostet.gin, 1936, 8: 18-52.—Zih, S. [Hemo- poietic effect of various organs] Magy. orv. arch, 1929, 30: 165-70.—Zolczzi, G. Particolarit& di azione del rosso Congo sul apparato emopoietico. Pathologica, Genova, 1935, 27: 93-101. ---- Physiology. Balo, J. Die Wirkung der Luftverdiinnung auf das Blut und die blutbildenden Organe. Zschr. ges. exp. Med, 1928, 59: 303-15. (elentano. P. Gli organi ematopoietici in gravidanza. Arch, ostet. gin.. 1931. 2. ser, 18: 463-502, pl— Ciaccio, C. R61e anabolique et catabolique des tissus hemopoietiques. Biol, med. Par, 1913, 11: 163-87.—Fukai, C. Reaktion der blutbildenden Organe und das Blutbild bei erhohter Tempera- tur. Tr. Soc. path, jap, 1935, 25: 329-34, 2 pl.—Gerhartz, H. Organe der Blutbildung und des Eisenstoff wechsels. In Handb. Biochem. (Oppenheimer, C.) 2. Aufl, Jena, 1936, Erganz. 3: 749-68.—Halberstaedter, L, & Simons, A. Die Wirkung der Radium-, Kathoden-,. Rontgen- und Lichtstrahlen auf die blutbildenden Organe und das Blut. In Handb. allg. Hamat. (Hirschfeld) Berl, 1932-33, 1: 2. Halftc, 1419-520.—Hsu, C. L, & Ma, W. C. Direct and indirect effects of Roentgen radiation on the blood-forming organs of rats. Am. J. Cancer, 1940, 39: 319-33.—ludina, N. D. [Reaction of the hemopoietic Bystem in castrated rats with athyreosis in relation to their age] J. med, Kiev, 1938, 8: 109-15. ------ [Reaction of the hemopoietic system of the rat to various stimuli during various age periodsl In Starost (Kiev. Akad. nauk USSR Inst. klin. fiziol.) Kiev, 1940, 187-90.—La Cascio, G. Rapporto tra azione sul tessuto emopoietico e fissazione nell'apparato reticolo- endoteliale del solfuro di rame colloidale. Boll. Soc. ital. biol sper, 1930. 5: 819-22-Takaizumi, M. Histologisches Stu- dium iiber den Einfluss der Rontgenstrahlen auf hiimatopoe- tische Organe. Tr. Jap. Path. Soc, 1928. 18: 101-5.— Tsuchiya, T. Changes in blood figure of dogs and histological findings in their haematopoietic organs caused by experimental forced rapid running. Jap. J. Exp. M, 1936, 14: 551-89.—Waugh, T. R. The interrelation of various systemic hematopoietic pro- cesses. Am IM. Sc, 1937, 193: 337-45.—Wirth, D. Studien zur ,i'-I •/iii-chen Reaktion der hamatopoetischen Organ- systtm (*"*'haemat, Lpz, 1933-34, 51: 242-50. ------& Kangjera, L. Studien zur artspezifischen Reaktion der hama- topoetischen Organsysteme. Ibid., 1936, 55: 400-5.—Wirth, D., & Schratt. A. Studien zur artspezifischen Reaktion der hamatopoetischen Organsysteme. Ibid, 1937, 58: 358-62. ---- Regulation. See also Blood formation; Gastric juice, Hemopoietin. Driagin, K. A. [Effect of the cortex of the large hemispheres on the quantity and composition of blood] Kazan, med, 1939, 35: No. 8, 93.—Komiya, E. Beitrag zum Mechanismus zentral- nervosen Regulation des Blutes. In Libro de oro M. R. Castex B. Air, 1938, 2: 735-47. ------ Mikamo, Y. [et al.] Experi- mentelle Untersuchungen iiber die zentral-nervose Regulation des Blutes; Beitrage zur Kenntnis des Verlaufes und der Yerteilung der das Blutbild rcgulierenden Nervenfasern. Jap J. M. Sc, 1938-39, 5: Proc. Int. Med, 20-2.- Mintz, J. I. [Clinical observations on the question of the central vegetative regulation of the blood] Sovet. psikhonevr, 1940, 16: No. 5, 91-9.—Okinaka, S, Morikawa, K. [et al.] Experimentelle Studien iiber den Einfluss des Spinalparasympathikus auf die Ausschwemmung der Blutbestandteile. Jap. J. M. Sc, 1938- 39, 5: Int. Med, 237. ---- in animals. Champy, C, & Louvel, J. Recherches sur l'hematopoiesc chez Protopterus annectens. Arch. anat. micr. Par, 1939-40, 35: 243-81, pl.—Hoch, P. Ueber die Histologic der Glandula intcrpasita des Frosches. Zschr. mikr. anat. Forsch, 1931, 24: 303-98.—Jordan, H. E. The histology of the blood and the blood-forming tissues of the urodele, Proteus anguineus. Am. J. Anat, 1932, 51: 215-51.—Kindred, J. E. A quantitative study of the hemopoietic organs of young albino rats. Ibid 1910, 67: 99-149, 2 pl.—Lochhcad, J. H, & Lochhead, M. S. Studies on the blood and related tissues in Artemia, Crustacea, Anostraca. J. Morph, 1941, 68: 593-632.—Storti, E. Con- tributo alia conoscenza degli organi ematopoietici delle scimmie (ricerche su Cercocebus lunulatus) Boll. Soc. med. chir, Pavia, 1929, n. ser, 4: 465-82.— Tishchenko, E. Die experi- mentellen Untersuchungen am Frosch (iber die Kernverschie- bung und deren Beziehung zu dem hamatopoetischen System. Fol. haemat, Lpz, 1931, 44: 261-309, 3 pi.—Varela, M. E, & Mancini, R. E. Sistema hemocitopoyetico del Bufo arenarum, Hensel; topograffa, citologla y observaciones sobre sus varia- ciones estacionales. Rev. Soc. argent, biol, 1938, 14: 468- 75, 4 pl.—Wirth, D. Die besondere Reaktionsweise der hamatopoetischen Organsysteme bei unseren Ilaustierurteri. Wien. tierarztl. Mschr, 1939, 26: 101-72.—Worth, R. Obser- vations on the blood and blood-forming organs of certain local Chiroptera. Fol. haemat, Lpz, 1932, 48: 337-54. HEMATOPOIETIC See under Gastric juice. HEMATOPORPHYRAN. See also Hematin; Porphyran. Bandow, F. Beitrag zur Kenntnis der Mctallkomplexsalze des Hamatoporphyrins. Zschr. physiol. Chem, 1934, 223: 71-3.—Davies, T. H. Metalloporphyrins; coordination of nitrogenous bases with iron meso-, proto-, and hematopor- phyrins. J. Biol. Chem, 1940, 135: 597^622. Also repr — Fischer, H, matoxylin and its application in analyses] Pharm. tid, Kbh, 1862-63,2:345-7.—Iwatsuru, R, & Kawagu- chi, M. Leber den Einfluss des Hematoxylins auf Atmung und Glvkolvse des Rattenkrebses sowie der Milz bei krebstragenden Tiereu. Biochem. Zschr, 1936, 284: 163-8.—Rivas Goday, S. Determinacion del hierro y el cobre por la hematoxilina. Bol. farm, mil., Madr, 1933, 11: 369-73. ---- Staining. See also Cell-nucleus, Staining; Staining. Barrett, W. C, jr. Heidenhain's hematoxylin used with the smear technic. Stain Techn, 1932, 7: 63.—Broussy, J. Sur un procede de coloration histologique rapide par Thema- toxvline. Arch. Soc. sc. med. biol. Montpellier, 1933, 14: 228-30— Burlend, T. H, & Strangeways, D. H. Note on a modification of Delafield's haematoxylin. J. Anat, Lond, 1937-38, 72: 631.—Carazzi, D. Ueber das Abbleichen von mit Hamatoxylinlosungen gefarbten Schnitten. Zschr. wiss. Mikr, 1911, 28: 271-3.—Ciaccio. C. Sopra alcune tinte di ematos- silina; nota di tecnica microscopica. Monit. zool. ital, 1907, 18: 46.—Clara, M. Leber die Darstellung der Gallenkapillaren durch Hamatoxylin-Beizenfarbungen; zugleich ein Beitrag zur Theorie der Hamatoxylinfarbungen. Zschr. Zellforsch, 1933, 17:699-728. ------ Ueber ein neues Molybdanhamatoxylin. Zschr. wiss. Mikr, 1933, 50: 73-7.—Cole, E. C. Isohematein as a biological stain. Stain Techn, 1931, 6: 93-6.—Dean, H. L. Delafield's hematoxylin and safranin for staining plant materials. Ibid, 1940, 15: 61-5.—Di Fiore, M. S. H. La hematoxilina como colorante electivo de las fibras elasticas Rev. Soc. argent, biol, 1934, 10: 423-8.—Fuse, G, & Suzuki! Y. Ueber das Solanylin ein Ersatzmittel des Hamatoxylins. Arb. Anat. Inst. Lniv. Sendai, 1935, H. 17, 175-82.—Grigorev, A. V. [On staining pieces of tissue in toto by sudan III and hematoxylin, and on obtaining from them series of sections on the freezing microtome] Russ. vrach, 1909, 8: 109; 146.— Gurwitsch, A. Ein schnelles Verfahren der Eisenhamatoxylin- farbung. Zsohr. w-iss. Mikr, 1901-2, 18: 291.—Hansen, F. C. C. Ueber Eisenhamatein, Chromalaunhamatein, Toner- dealaunhamatein, Hamatein -losungen und einige Coche- nillefarblosungen. Ibid, 1905, 22: 45-90.—Heidenhain, M. Fiinf und zwanzig Jahre Eisenhamatoxylin. Ibid, 1916-17, 33: 225-31.—Hollborn, K. Hamatoxylin (vereinfachte und verbesserte Hamatoxylin-Simultanfarbungen) Ibid, 1935, 52: 184-9.—Ide-Sozas, A. Zwei neue Farbungsmethoden mit Hamatoxylin. Ibid, 1-7.—Iron hematoxylin. Gradwohl Lab Digest, 1940-41, 4: No. 5, 9.—Johnson, <". M. A rapid tech- nique for iron-hematoxylin staining requiring no microscopic control of decolorization. Am. J. Trop. M, 1935, 15:551-3.— Krajian, A. A. A rapid and economical method for staining routine tissue sections, employing hematoxylin' and eosinol Gradwohl Lab. Digest, 1938, 1: \<>. 10, 5. bang. A. g! A stable, high-contrast mordant for hematow lin staining Stain Techn, 1936, 11: 149 51. Lillie. R. I>„ . -Nitch, ('. A. R. The significance of haematuria. Clin. .1, Lond, 1933, 62: 461-5.—Nonnenbruch, W. Leber die klinische Bedeutung der Hamaturie. Munch, med. Wschr, 1937, 84: 241-3.—Orr, L. The significance of hematuria to the general practitioner. J. Florida M. Ass, 1928-29, 15: 339-42.—Parker, G. E. The significance of small traces of blood in the urine. Postgrad. M. J, Lond, 1936, 12: 445-9.—Patterson, M. Importance and interpretation of hematuria. South. M. & S, 1934, 96: 353.- Pflaumer, E. Blutharn als Symptom und Behandlungs- gcueii.-tand. Jahrkurs. arztl. Fortbild, 1938, 29: H. 4, 10-21 — Sargent, J. C. Hematuria; a common problem of general practice. Wisconsin M. J, 1930, 29: 367-70.—Sinkoe, S. J. Hematuria and longevity. Urol. Cut. Rev, 1930, 34: 684-7.— Stirling, W. C. The significance of bleeding from the urinary tract. Med. Ann. District of Columbia, 1940, 9: 434-8. Also repr.—Strachstein, A. The significance of hematuria. N. York State J. M, 1926, 26: 748.—Urinary bleeding; bloody urine, an indication of urinary tract disease, demands thorough- going investigation; and, when such bleeding is of serious amount measures for its control should be considered. Ther. Notes, Detr, 1940, 47: 332-4.—Vermooten, V. The significance of haematuria. S. Afr. M. J, 1938, 12: 434.—Wade, H. The significance of haematuria. Brit. M. J, 1932, 1: 177-80.— Walker, K. The interpretation of haematuria. Clin. J, Lond, 1931, 60: 105-7.—Warner, E. C. The medical aspect of haema- turia. Postgrad. M. J, Lond, 1932, 8: 409-13.—Wilhelmi, O. J. Hematuria and pyuria; urological aids to the general practitioner. J. Missouri M. Ass, 1928, 25: 468-73.—Williams, L. Occasional haematuria. Med. Press & Circ, Lond, 1906, n. ser, 81: 172. ---- Diagnosis. Atherton, L. Diagnostic significance of hematuria. Ken- tucky M. J, 1937, 35: 380.—Ball, W. G. On the value of modern methods of investigation in the diagnosis and treat- ment of haematuria. Lancet, Lond, 1927, 11: 473-8.—Barach, J. H, & Pennock, L. L. Diagnostic value of occult hematuria a studv of 3,000 specimens of urinary sediment. J. Am. M. Ass, 1940, 114:640-2.—Blum, V. Eikennung und Behandlung der Hamblutungen. Wien. klin. Wschr, 1928, 41: 1683-5. ------ Differential diagnosis and therapy of urinary bleedings. Ars. medici, Wien, 1934, 12: 147-51.—Boas, E. [Diagnosis of hematuria] Ugeskr. laeger, 1928, 90: 1074.—Christian, H. M. The significance and diagnosis of various forms of hematuria Proc. Philadelphia Co. M. Soc, 1902-3, 23: 144-9.—Egyedi, D. [Meaning of hematuria in diagnosis] Budapesti orv. ujs, 1926, 24: 1447-52.—Ferrata, A. Diagnosi e terapia delle ematurie. Arch. ital. chir, 1930, 27: 819-24. Also Morgagni, 1930, 72: 2284-7. Also Studium, Nap, 1930, 20: 467-74. Le ematurie (diagnosi e terapia) (tema en comune con la Society Italiana di chirurgia) Riforma med, 1930, 46: 1619- 21. Also Dia med, B. Air, 1930-31, 3: 483-5. Also Arch. Soc ital. chir, 1931, 37: 401T50— Frontz, W. A. Hematuria with special reference to the importance of an early recognition of the conditions causing it. Delaware M. J, 1933, 5: 47-50.— Fullerton, A. On the diagnosis of haematuria. Med. Press & Circ, Loud, 1908, n. ser, 85: 554.—Gibby, H. B. Hematuria as a symptom. Lehigh Valley M. Mag, 1901, 12: 77-84.— Gusev, B. M. [Pseudohematuria and its practical value] Vrach. gaz, 1914, 21: 1034.—Harris, R. G. S. Haematuria; diagnosis and treatment. Med. J. Australia, 1940, 2: 501-4.— Haslinger, K. Diagnose und Behandlung der Hamblutungen Wien. klin. Wschr, 1940, 53: 527-9.—Hirt, W. Die Diagnose der Hamaturie. Wien. klin. Rdsch, 1904, 18: 553; 575 Die Diagnose der Hamaturie bei alten Leuten. Zbl. Chir, 1934, 61: 2100-2.—Jelm, C. E. Diagnostic significance of hematuria' Ohio M J, 1927, 23: 911-1.—Lasio, G. B. I* ematuria (diag- nosi e cura) Morgagni, 1930, 72: 2288-96. Also Studium Nap, 1930, 20: 509-16.—Laurent, E. De l'hematurie aii point de vue du diagnostic. Arch. med. beiges, 1903, 4. ser.. 22: 316-25.—Leotard. L'hematurie au point de vue dii diagnostic. Ibid, 1901, 4. ser, 18: 154-65.—Loughnane, F. McG. The differential diagnosis of haematuria. Clin J Lond, 1928, 57: 385-90.—Luys, G. Diagnostic etiologique de rhematurie. Clinique, Par, 1906, 1: 291-3. Signification diagnostique de l'hematurie. Ibid, 1927, 22: 99. Also Med. Press & Cue, Lond, 1927, n. ser, 124: 239.— Mercier, O. Diagnostic des hematuries. Union med Canada 1927, 56: 512-20.—Naegeli, O. Differentialdiagnose der Hamaturien. In his Differ. Diagn. inn. Med, Lpz, 1936-37 574-6.—Noszkay, A. [Differential diagnosis of hemorrhage from urinary tract] Orv. hetil, 1937, 81: mell, 79.—Pulido Martin, A. Hematuria; su diagnostico. Siglo med, 1910 57- 2; 20; 35.—Quinby, W. C. Diagnosis and treatment of hema- turia. Proc. Interst. Postgrad. M. Ass. N. America (1930) 1931.6:155-8.—Quintard, E. Pseudo-hematurie. Arch med Angiers, 1908, 12: 330-4.—Randolph, W. M. The diagnostic value of haematuria. Old Dominion J. M. & S, 1904-5 3- 211-4.—Scheibel, P. [Haematuria and its clinical diaunosisi Gy6gj-8£zat, 1932, 72: 385-9.—Wassink, W. F. [Glossy urine Ned. tschr. geneesk, 1933, 77: 4035-8.—Weyeneth, R." Diag- nostic differentiel des hematuries k propos de 2 cas rare! Schweiz. med. Wschr, 1941, 71: 481; 501.—Wolbarst, A. l' Hematuria, with special reference to diagnosis. Med. J & Rec, 1927, 125: 112-6. Also repr.—Young, H. II. Diagnoei: and treatment of hematuria. Atlantic M. J, 1925-26 29a 587-9. ---- Diagnosis: Tests. See also under Cast [urinary]; Hemoglobinuria; also Urine, Sediment. Astraldi, A. Un metodo para dosar la P. S. P. en laa orinas hematurias. Rev. espec, B. Air, 1928, 3: 791.—Calvin. J. K, & Carbone, J. Erythrocytes in urinary sediment in health and in disease (scarlet fever) studies by the orthotolidine test Am. J. Dis. Child, 1939, 57: 1035-43.—Cohn, E., & Mislo^ witzer, E. Ueber die quantitative Beziehung zwischen Blut- menge im Harn und Ervthrocytenbefund im Sediment. Zschr klin. Med, 1932, 120: 193-8.—Gill, C. ('. The Stone-Burko orthotolidine test for hematuria. Mil. Surgeon, 1939, 85: 501-6. Also repr.—Larsen, K. Chemical demonstration o{ small amounts of blood in the urine. J. Lab. Clin. M, 1936-37, 22: 935-43.—Noriega del Aguila, M. Causas de error en la investigaci6n de sangre en ciertas orinas, por el reactivo de Thevenon y Rolland. Cr6n. med, Lima, 1939, 56: 62-4.— Ockerblad, N. F. An accurate method of estimating pus and blood cells in urine. J. Urol, Bait, 1928, 19: 525.—Schroeder, K. [Examination for blood in urine] Ugeskr. la;ger, 1929 91 • 1015-7.—Stone, W. J., & Burke, G. T. An improved test for occult blood, especially in the urine. J. Am. M. Ass 1934 102: 1549. Also Ind. M. Gaz, 1934, 69: 585.—Volante, ¥. Sulla determinazione quantitativa dei globuli rossi nelle orine ematuriche. Diagn. techn. lab. Nap, 1931, 2: 944-52.— Ziegelroth, P. Eine sehr empfindliche und einfache Blutprobe, insbesondere bei Hamaturie. Deut. med. Wschr, 1929 55- 1641. ---- essential (so-called) See also subheadings (hematogenous; renal) Courchet, L. *Des hematuries dites essen- tielles. 65p. 8? Montp., 1912. Held, H. L. H. *Beitrag zur Frage der sogenannten essentiellen Hamaturie [Munster] 23p. 8? Oberhausen, 1934. Aars Nicolaysen, N. [Is essential haematuria a deficiency disease?] Med. rev, Bergen, 1933, 50: 193-211.—Aitken, J. Congenital, hereditary, and family haematuria. Lancet, Lond, 1909, 2: 444-6.—Backer, I. [Essential hematuria] Budapesti orv. ujs, 1931, 29: 449-52.—Blavet di Briga, C. Contributo alio studio delle ematurie essenziali. Arch. sc. med. Tor. 1928, 52: 106-11.—Block, J. C. Essential hematuria. Am. J. Derm. Genitourin. Dis, 1908, 12: 221-3.—Blum, V. Fami- liare essentielle Hamaturie; Beitrag zur Frage der Oslerschen Krankheit. Med. Klin, Berl, 1936, 32: 1254.—Borsotti, P. C. Su di un caso di ematuria essenziale e sulla sua interpretazione patogenetica. Arch. ital. urol, 1936, 13: 289-310.—Bumpus, H. C. Essential hematuria: a clinical study. J. Am. M. Ass, 1928, 90: 593-6.—Burkland, C. E. Use of vitamin C in the treatment of essential hematuria. J. Urol, Bait, 1939, 41: 401-5.—Carter, L. J. The X-ray treatment of essential hema- turia. Radiology, 1931, 16: 944.—Chaiudano, C. Su le ematurie essenziali. Arch. ital. urol, 1926-27, 3: 34-59 — Chwalla, R. Ueber seltene Ursachen von Nierenblutung; ein Beitrag zur Frage der essentiellen Hamaturie und Nephralgia Zschr. Urol, 1932, 26: 449; 521.—Cook, E. N., & Braasch, W. F. Essential hematuria. Proc. Mayo Clin, 1936, 11: 669-72 — Costa, C. Di un caso di ematuria idiopatica. Riv. med, 1910, 18: 55-7.—Deddes, E. [So-called essential haematuria] Ned. tschr. geneesk, 1933, 77: 1788.—Devaux. Ein Beitrag zur Lehre von der essentiellen Hamaturie. Zschr. gyn. Urol, 1908-9, 1: 101-5.—Dorst, J. Een geval van pseudo-essentieele haematune. Ned. tschr. geneesk, 1902, 2. R, 28: 409-15.— Dziembowski, S. de. Sur l'hematurie sans cause anatomique evidente. P. verb. Congr. fr. chir, 1936, 45: 501-11.—Frigaux, L. Les hematuries pseudoessentielles. Clinique, Par, 1910, 5: 709.—Gaeta, G. Sulle cosidette ematurie essenziali. Arch. Soc. ital. chir, 1931, 37: 935.—Gahlemann, C. Essentielle Hamaturie im Kindesalter. Mschr. Kinderh, 1938, 74: 45- '■ Guthrie, L. G. Idiopathic or congenital hereditary and amily hematuria. Lancet, Lond, 1902, 1: 1243-6. Also Med. Press & Circ, Lond, 1902, n. ser, 73: 484-6.—Hager, B. H. Direct irradiation of the kidney; a means of controlling idiopathic hematuria. J. Am. M. Ass, 1930, 94: 762-4. Also repr.—Haslinger, K. Zur Frage der sogenannten essentiellen Hamaturie. Wien. med. Wschr, 1933, 83: 1233-5.—Hilde- brandt, A. Ueber einen Fall von einseitiger essentieller Hama- turie. Chante Ann, Berl, 1908, 32: 342-4.—Hutter, K. Beitrag zu den Blutungen aus anatomisch anscheinend unveranderter Niere. Zschr. Urol, 1934, 28: 303-5.— Jacoulet, F- Hematuries essentielles et nephrites hematuriques. Progr. med. Par, 1911, 3. ser, 27: 325-7.—Jemma, R. Ematuria essenziale nei bambini. Rinasc. med, 1926, 3: 251—Karaffa, K. W von. Leber die sogenannte essentielle Hamaturie. Fol. urol, Lpz, 1907, 1: 323-37.—Kilduffe, R. A. Essential hema- t^; report of a case with histologic examination of the kidney. J. M. Soc. N. Jersey, 1928, 25: 575-7.—Krohn, H. Zur Frage too-7SOJ!orla;m2ten essentielleri Hamaturie. Zschr. urol. Chir, 1927, 22: 467-76.—Lino, G. Delia cosi detta ematuria essen- ziale. Ann. i tal. chir, 1929, 8: 1045-58.—Lofberg, O. The HEMATURIA 48S HEMATURIA so-called essential haematuria. Acta chir. scand, 1932, 72: 161-73.-Morgenstern, M. Ueber passagere (idiopathische) Hamaturie im Kindesalter Med.. Khn Berl 1931 27: 545_Neave, S. Family haematuria. S. Barth. Hosp. J, Lond 1905-6 13: 123.—Nicolich, G. Contributo al problema delle nefriti ematuriche e delle ematurie cosidette essenziab. Arch. Soc. ital. chir 1931 37: 648-83.-Pause N N 0m essentiel haematuri. Norsk mag laegevid, 1909, 5. R, 7: o.of.i:__Peters C. N. Essential hematuria with unusual case report N. England J. M, 1930, 203: 1015-20.-Pincus. Essentielle Hamaturie. Deut. med Wschr, 1908, 34: 1980- 2__pisani, L. Le ematurie essenziali (studio ezio-patogenetico ed anatomo-patologico) Arch. ital. anat. pat, 1930, 1: 711- cg 4 Pi__Raines, S. L. Essential hematuria; case report. Memphis M. J, 1941, 16: 85—Rathbun, N. P. Essential hematuria. Tr. Am. Ass. Genitourin. Surgeons, 1926, 19: 253-82 —Remlinger, F. Sur la frequence k Tanger de l'hema- turie dite essentielle. Bull. Soc. path, exot. Par, 1927, 20: 989-91__Rigdon, R. L. The diagnosis of essential hematuria. Am J. Urol, 1910, 6: 171-8.—Rinaldi, R. La questione delle pmaturie essenziali (sifilide ed ematuria; diatesi emorragica ed ematuria) Arch. ital. urol, 1930, 6: 624-45-Rivoir, J. Idionathische arterielle Hypertension als Aetiologie essentieller Hamaturie. Deut. med. Wschr, 1937, 63:140. Also C. rend Congr. internat. path, comp, 1936, 3. Congr, 624-8.— Robinson, R, & Jacoulet, F. Sur les hematuries dites essentielles. Med. acad. travail, 1910, 8: 582-607.— Sandukovsky, I. E. [Blood transfusion in essential hematuria] Urologia, Moskva, 1940, 17: No. 3, 22-4 — Schenck, B. R. Concerning so-called essential hematuria, with especial reference to the hematuria accompanying mild grades of nephritis. Surg. Gyn. Obst, 1911, 13: 68-71 — Spaziante, L. Sulla ematuria essenziale. Gior. internaz. sc. med, 1903, n. ser., 25: 209-24.—Swinney, J. Some aspects of the pathology of essential haematuria. Newcastle M.J, 1939, 19: 51-7.—Watkins, C. H, & Thompson, G. J. Results in treatment of essential hematuria with moccasin venom. Proc. Mayo Clin, 1937, 12: 200.—Webb-Johnson, A., & Warwick. W T Essential haematuria; are lesions of a renal papilla frequent cause? Brit. J. Urol, 1941, 13: 127-34.—Weijtlandt, J A [On so-called essential hematuria] Ned. tschr. geneesk, 1939*, 83: 2282-91.—Wilbur, D. L, & Priestley, J. T. Essential hematuria; a clinical and pathologic study. Ann. Surg, 1935, 101- 647-58. Also in Surgery (Ravdin, I. S.) Phila, 1935, 647-58. --- Etiology. See also names of local pelvic, urogenital and systemic diseases as Appendicitis; Bladder, Inflammation; Colon bacillus, Infection by; Enterorenal syndrome; Genitals [male] Hemor- rhage; Leukemia; Pyelonephritis; Nephritis, &c. Almeida Cotjto, J. L. de. *Hematuna endemica. 54p. 8? Bahia, 1872. Albarran. Les hematuries d'origine uretrale et prostatique. M6d. mod. Par, 1903, 14: 409.—Bianchini, M. L. Ematuria tropicale fulminant*. Ann. med. nav. Roma, 1902, 8: 599- 611—Bloch, G. Su due casi di ematuria di oscura origine. Arc'h. ital. urol, 1927, 4: 39-48. Also Arch. Soc. ital. chir, 1931 37: 688-702.—Boston, L. N. Two examples of parasitic hematuria. Am. Med, 1903, 5: 20.' Also J. Med. Chir. Coll, Phila 1902 3: No. 2, 6-9.—Bridge, J. F. An unusual cause of hematuria.' Brit. M. J, 1910, 2: 1344.-Brn.ne Moot™ Amstel. P. J. de. Haematuria uit gezonde nieren. Med. wbl, Amst, 1908, 14: 593; 606; 617.—Caldarera, E. II fenomeno di Sanarelli-Shwartzman in rapporto ad alcune forme di ematuria. Arch. ital. urol, 1935, 12: 737-57.-Cavall.nu E. Ematuria nella tubercolosi polmonare. Ann. med. nav, Roma 1929, ib. pt 2, 197-201.—Celentano, A. Etiopatogenesi e diagnostica deli'ematuria nell'infanzia. Pediatna (Riv.) 1931,39:051- 7.—Charnock, D. A. Miscellaneous causes of hematuria. Urol. Cut. Rev, 1941, 45: 498.—Chetwood, C. H , & Flagg,A. G. Tabloid summary of hematuria causation. Ibid, 1361, ii>. 483-7__Cleland, J. B. Endemic hematuria or lllawarra redwater in bovines and its possible occurrence in man. Aus- tralas. M. Gaz, 1911, 30:70-2.—Correia Dias. Un cas d hima- turie attribuee k la presence d'un tenia. J. boc. sc. med. Lisboa 1905, 69: 52-7.-Cumston, C. G. The pathogenesis and treatment of the symptom hematuria. Am. J. Urol., 1907, 3: 28-40. Also repr—Del Rio, A. Hematurias neopldsicas. Rev med, Puebla, 1941, 14: No. 127, 6-12 Also Rev ?iex cir 1941 9- 13-9 —Flye Sainte-Marie, P. E. Organisme voisin de la Sergentella hominis trouve dans des urines; san- glantes. Bull. Soc. path, exot. Par 1928, 21: 515-7.—Funk, W. H. Hematuria, associated with acute upper respiratory infection. U. S. Nav. M. Bull, 1940 38: 311-25 -Gasbarr.n., A. Ematuria di origine oscura. Policlinico, 1934, 41. sez. prat, 203-9.—Gebele. Ueber Hamaturie nach "itravenosen Cylotropininjektionen. Munch, med. Wschr, 1929, 7b. 1630.-Hagner, F. R. Angioneurotic hematuria of lfi> years duration. Tr. Am. Ass. Genitourin. Surgeons 1931, 24. 9H.- Heinsen, H. A. Zur Frage der angioneurotischen Hamaturie bei jugendlichen Vasomotorikern. Deut. med^WsfcqS 66: 1181-3.-HermanSen, I., & Del Pino, M. Hematuria renal en el tratamiento con sulfopiridina. Rev.ma Chile, 1941 69: 203—Iilyes, G. [Hematuria and tumor] Orv, hetil, 1933, 77: 529-31.—Jura, V. L'ematuria colibacillare. Arch. ital. urol, 1930-31, 7: 572-88.—Keller, W. Zur Kasui- stik der Hamaturie im Kindesalter. Mschr. Kinderh, 1939, 79: 376-81.—Kuyama, S, & Yoshino, K. Ueber einen Bazillus aus der Hamaturie des Knaben. Okayama igakkai zasshi, 1937, 49: 1549.—Le-Roy, C. M. Le ematurie da colibacillo. Arch. ital. urol, 1934-35, 11: 311-65.—Li Virghi, G. Ematuria iniziale. Gior. internaz. sc. med, 1909, n. ser, 31: 598-604.— Lower, W. E. A clinical report on some causes of hematuria. Cleveland M. J, 1907, 6: 57-60, pl.—Markert, W. [Hema- turia, its origin and treatment] Polskie arch. med. wewn, 1936, 14: 147-62.—Neale, A. V. Haematuria during treatment with insulin. Brit. M. J, 1928, 2: 442.—Ochsenius, K. Alimentare Hamaturie im Kindesalter. Mschr. Kinderh, 1932, 53: 217-9.—Pace, F. C. Unusual source of gross haema- turia. Brit. J. Urol, 1931, 3: 52-6.—Payne, R.L. Haematuria, due to unusual cause. Charlotte M. J, 1903, 22: 88.—Pierrot, A. Hematuries et troubles intestinaux. Strasbourg med, 1927, 85: 278-96.—Pugh, W. S. Hematuria and uterine dis- orders. Clin. Med, 1941, 48: 242-4.—Rau, B. S. A case of haematuria relieved after removal of a cystic tumour of the great omentum. Ind. M. Gaz, 1926, 61: 599.—Ray, E. H. Hematuria; a classification and discussion of its causes with case reports. Med. World, 1937, 55: 32-6.—Rosenblum, P. S. Haematuria of urethral origin. Urol. Cut. Rev, 1927, 31: 421.— Scorcu, A. Le cause di ematuria nell'infanzia. Prat, pediat, Genova, 1931, 9: 375-87.—Thomas, J. D. Dietetic hematuria with some remarks upon oxaluria as a cause. Virginia M. Semi-Month, 1900-1, 5: 685-8.—Valerio, A. Hematuria e appendicite. Brasil med, 1928, 42: 209. ------ Hematurias terminaes sem les5es da bexiga. Ibid, 1936, 50: 386.—Wein- stein, M. A. Acute ear, nose and throat infections com- plicated with hematuria. Arch. Pediat, N. Y, 1936, 53: 515- 28.—Zaffagnini, A. Ematuria e colecistite calcolosa (nota clinica) Arch. ital. urol, 1927, 4: 161-70. ---- hematogenous. See also diseases of the blood and of the hema- topoietic system. Connor, H. M, & Bumpus, H. C, jr. Essential hematuria and its possible relationship to purpura hemorrhagica. Am. J. M. Sc, 1927, 173: 176-84.—Gregoire, R, Michon, L, & Couvelaire, R. H6maturies hemogeniques: variete d'hema- turies dites essentielles. Bull. Soc. fr. urol, 1934, 198-206. Also J. urol. med. Par, 1934, 38: 44-52.—Lange, C. de. Haematurie als eerste en eening symptoom van Morbus Barlowi. Ned. tschr. geneesk, 1902, 2. R, 28: pt 2, 250-4 — McKenna. C. M, & Birch, C. La F. Hematogenous hematuria. J. Urol, Bait, 1939, 42: 171-82.—Malherbe, A. Note sur un cas d'hematurie grave d'origine hemophilique survenue chez I'homme k la suite d'un catheterisme. Ann. mal. org. genito- urin. Par, 1905, 23: 680-3.—Pearson, H. B. A. Notes of a case of haematuria due to the haemorrhagic diathesis. Lancet, Lond, 1904, 1:91. ---- postoperative, and traumatic. See also such headings as Kidney, Injury, &c. Wegmann, R. *Ueber Nachblutungen bei subkutanen Nierenverletzungen. 63p. 22^cm. Zur., 1939. . . t „ . Dolan, L. P. Hematuria and its significance following automobile accidents; modern means of diagnosis and treat- ment. Ohio M. J, 1939, 35: 825-7.—Frank, E. R. W. Ueber posttraumatische funktionelle Nierenblutungen. Deut. Zschr. Chir, 1933, 241: 734. ------& Jaffe, R. Ueber posttrauma- tische funktionelle Nierenblutungen. Ibid, 74-83.—Ualz.n, h. Contusion du flanc droit; hematurie persitante avec exacer- bations aigues graves. Arch. med. pharm. mil, 1911, 57: 21-6 —Jianu, A. Postoperative renal hemorrhage. Internat. M Blue Book, 1939, 10: 23-5.—Slaviero, A. Trattamento chiruraico conservative nella emorragia renale postoperatona. Arch. ital. chir, 1935, 40: 727-40.-Zaniboni,B. Ematuria renale creduta traumatica. Gazz. osp, 1905, 2b: 75-7. ---- recurrent. Attlee W H W. Three cases of recurrent haematuria occur- ring in one family. S. Barth. Hosp..J, Lond, 1901-2, 9: 41^- HaoDel. T. J. Recurring hematuria (non-malarial) ir. M. Soc Tennessee, 1907, 74: 212-9.-Lugli, A. Un caso di ema- turia parossistica consecutiva a ca1t^erl?Qnri0o , 9, ' Q* — Lancisiana osp. Roma, 1901-2, 21: 185; 1903-4 23: 93- Nisio, G. Ematurie intermittenti di origine tonsillare. Arch. tal. urol, 1926-27, 3: 241-52-Troitsk! I. I. [Intermittent haematuria] Med. obozr, Moskva, 1893, 12: 709-11.— Warren G. W. Intermittent hematuria. Post-Graduate, N. Y, 1909, 24: 997-1003. ---- renal, and ureteral. See also Kidney (Calculus; Tumor) Nephritis, hemorrhagic; Tuberculosis, renal; Ureter, ln- 1UAndrack, H. *Zur Frage der neurotischen Nierenblutung. 23p. 8? Jena, 1932, HEMATURIA 486 HEMATURIA Bincen, A. *Zur Frage der essontiellen Nierenblutung [Giessen] lOp. 8? Lpz., 1930. Aievoli. L'indirizzo chirurgico nelle ematurie renali di non prccisata natura. Morgagni, 1934, 76: 1427.—Alberti, V. Ematuria in rene nefralgico, decapsulazione, guarigione. Arch. Soc. ital. chir, 1931, 37: 931-4.—Alexander, J. C. Renal hematuria. Med. Rec, Houston, 1939, 33: 308-11.—Allemann R. Die renale Hamaturie. Schweiz. med. Wschr, 1932, 62: 1104-8.—Alvarez Colodrero, J. W, Arrues, L. D, & Bianchi, A. Comentarios sobre un caso de nefritis hematurica. Rev. argent. urol, 1939, 8: 479-86.—Anderson, J. C. Persistent haematuria from a minute papilloma of the renal pelvis. Brit. J. Surg, 1929-30, 17: 696-8.—Ascoli, R. Ematurie renali da causa rara. Osp. maggiore, Milano, 1933, 21: 461-72.—Atkins, T. G. A clinical lecture on the treatment of haematuria of renal origin. Med. Press & Circ, Lond, 1906, n. ser, 81: 438-11.—Baggio, G. Ematuria da stasi sanguigna per innessione del peduncolo renale. Atti Soc. sc. med. natur. Cagliari, 1929, 31: 52-62. Also Gazz. med. lombarda, 1929, 87: 243-9. Also Policlinico, 1930, 37: sez. prat, 251-5.—Balkanyi, P. Die Bedeutung der renalen Hamaturien in der Chirurgie. Med. Klin, Berl, 1926, 22: 1367-71.—Ball, A. Renal haematuria. Irish J. M. Sc, 1927, 6. ser, 101-7. Also Urol. Cut. Rev, 1927, 31: 271-5.— Bartels, L. Hematuria of renal and ureteral origin. Week. Bull. S. Louis M. Soc, 1934, 28: 398.—Bewertung von Blutun- gen aus den Harnwegen und die Funktionsprufung bei uro- logischen Erkrankungen. Schweiz. med. Wschr, 1937, 67: 196.—Boeckel, A. Hematuries renales. Strasbourg med, 1933, 93: 433-8.—Bullock, J. E. The treatment of haematuria of renal origin. Practitioner, Lond, 1906, 76: 693-8.— Casper, L. Nieren- und Nierenbeckenblutungen. Wien. med. Wschr, 1926, 76: 1138-40.—Ceelen, W. Ueber essentielle Nierenblutungen. Virchows Arch, 1930, 275: 674-87.— Christian, H. M. Haematuria of renal origin. N. York M. J, 1907, 86: 778-81.—Chute, A. L. Renal and ureteral hematuria. Am. J. Urol, 1907, 3: 1-11. Also Boston M. & S. J, 1907, 116: 33-6.—Cilento, M. Considerazioni anatomo-patologiche e cliniche sulle ematurie renali in genere ed in ispecie nella tuber- colosi del parenchima renale. Rass. internaz. chn. ter, 1928, 9: 169-79.—Congdon, A. P. A study in hematuria in surgical conditions of the urinary tract. West. M. Rev, 1910, 15: 509-18.—Corbett, D. G. Unilateral renal bleeding without clinical evidence of disease or abnormality. Tr. West. Soc. Am. Urol. Ass, 1939, 8: 45^54. Also J. Urol, Bait, 1939, 42: 1179-88.—Davanzo, I. Sui rapporti fra ematoma perirenale con ematuria essenziale e la periarterite nodosa. Clin, chir, Milano, 1935, 38: 903-23.—Deschapelles, C. B. Hematuria por vaso anormal supernumerario del polo inferior del rinon. Vida nueva, Habana, 1933, 31: 106-9.—Devine, C. J. Hemor- rhage from the urinary tract. Virginia M. Month, 1936-37, 63: 334—6.—Docimo, L. Ematuria da glomerulo-nefrite emorragica monolaterale. Rinasc. med, 1931, 8: 9.—Ebhardt, K. Beitrag zur Frage der Nierenbeckenblutungen. Beitr. khn. Chir, 1931-32, 154: 541-50.—Eshner, A. A. Unilateral renal haematuria. Am. J. M. Sc, 1903, 125: 638-58. Also repr.—Gayet. Ancient foyer de tuberculose renale exclu; infection secondaire, hemorragies k type neoplasique. J. urol. m6d. Par, 1927, 23: 353-7— Goldbergas, T. [Renal hema- turia due to arteriosclerosis] Medicina, Kaunas, 1930, 11: 413-8.—Gottlieb, I. G. Renale Hamaturie aus kleinem Herd (sogenannte essentielle Hamaturie) Zschr. Urol, 1933, 27: 299-310.—Gubb, A. S. Notes on a case of grave recurrent renal haemorrhage. Med. Press & Circ, Lond, 1929, n. ser, 127: 492.—Haas, W. G. de [Renal hemorrhage! Ned. tschr. geneesk, 1939, 83: 582-6.—Hageman, P. O. Hematuria; a ureteral clot 6 feet long in a case of lymphosarcoma. J. Urol, Bait, 1940, 43: 734-6.—Haynes. I. S. Unilateral renal hema- turia due to pyelitis cystica. Ann. Surg, 1908, 48: 417-35, 3 pl. [Discussion] 462, pl. Also M. & S. Rep. Bellevue Hosp, N. Y, 1907-8, 3: 283-302.—Heitz-Boyer. A propos de la variete hematurique du syndrome entero-renal; hematurie colibacillaire grave, rebelle, recidivant depuis 5 ans; gu6rie uniquement et seulement par le traitement intestinal. J. urol. m6d. Par, 1934, 37: 265-70.—Hornyak, G. [Operated case of kidney haemorrhage of mysterious origin] Gyogydszat, 1927, 67: 179.—Hortolomei, N. Hematuries renales d'origine dynamique. J. urol. med. Par, 1934, 38: 564.—Hiickel, R. Anatomischer Beitrag zur Klarung dunkler Nierenblutungen Deut. Zschr. Chir, 1927, 201: 109-9. ------ Beitrag zur Frage der sogenannten essentiellen Hamaturie (Nierenblutung aus kleinem Herd) Zschr. urol. Chir, 1928, 25: 242-4.— Hunner, G. L. Are the so-called essential hematurias chiefly due to ureteral stricture? Tr. South. Surg. Ass, 1931 43- 267-90, 2 pl. Also repr. Also Am. J. Surg, 1932, n. ser.', 16: 279-300.—Hyman, A. Massive hematuria complicating pye- lonephritis. Ibid, 1928, n. ser, 4: 438-40.—Jacobs, A. A case of haematuria arising from one segment of a double kidney treated by resection. Brit. J. Surg, 1929-30, 17: 179-81 — Kanauka. V. [Hematuria due to arterio-sclerosis of the kidnevl Medicina, Kaunas, 1930, 11: 179-81.—Krecke, A. Die Bedeutung der Blutungen aus den Harnwegen. In his Beitr prakt. Chir, Miinch, 1934, 523-6. ------ Linksseitige Nierenblutung Ibid, 526—Lasz, I. [Treatment of urologicll hemorrhages] Cluj. med, 1936, 17: 464-6.—Lockwood I H Renal hematuria from the standpoint of the roentgenologist' Lrol. Cut. Rev 1932, 36: 84-8—McGuinness, M. C L A caae of renal hematuria. Phys. Ther, 1926 44- 346-9 — Mazer, C. Renal hematuria. Atlantic M. J.,' 1926-27 30- 167-70.—Mikkelsen, O. [Profuse renal hemorrhage, causes and treatment of obscure hemorrhages] Hospitalstidende, 1935, 78: 917; 945.—Minder, G. [Diagnostic importance of renal pain and hematuria] Orv. hetil, 1932, 76: 1097-100.— Mouriquand, Wenger & Romagny. Un cas dc nephrite hema- turique persistant depuis 8 mois. tr£s amclion' par la scarlatinp Lyon med, 1938, 162: 620-2.—Muschat. M. Renal papillary hemorrhage; report of a case with a discussion of essential hematuria. Med. J. 162: 479-82.-Phelip. L. Hematuries cohbacillaires; anune; double decapsulation renale; retablisse- ment de la s6cretion et du fonctionnement renal. Bull. Soc. fr. urol. 1930, 9: 39-42.—Pozdora, P. [Decapsula- tion m renal hemorrhage] Gy6gyaszat, 1935, 75: 490. Also Zschr. urol. Chir, 1935-36, 41: 370— Scher, S. A case of f?5minePhrectomy for haematuria. Brit. J. Urol, 1935, 7: 264-7.—Stoeckel. Nephrektomie bei essentieller Nieren- blutung Zschr. Geburtsh. Gyn, 1932-33, 104: 525-7.— Ward, R. O, & Freeman, E. A. A case of vesical and renal purpura requiring nephrectomy on account of hemorrhage. Brit J. Urol, 1930, 2: 151-3.—Warner. Ueber Decapsulation bei Hamaturie. Zschr. Urol, 1929, 23: 1001-4. ---- Treatment. Chwalla, R. Die Hamaturie und ihre Be- handlung. 64p. 24^cm. Lpz., 1939. * *e,oth F- lUr?log>cal impnn.-^ce and treatment of hema- turia] Magy. urol., 1940, 3: 83-8.- Ferrier, P. A. Control of urinary hemorrhage. California West. M, 1927, 26: 480-2.— txreen, L J Haematuria treated by injection of serum. Brit. M. J., 1927, 1: 761—Hubbard, T. B. Medical and surgical HEMATURIA 487 HEMATURIA treatment of hematuria. J. M. Ass. Alabama, 1934-35, 4: 238-41.—Kaufmann, R. Treatment of urinary haemorrhage. Med. Press & Circ, Lond, 1905, n. ser, 80: 298.—Lamiaud, H, & Pinault. Le gluconate de chaux dans le traitement des h6morragies urinaires. Bull, med. Par, 1932, 46: 557.— Lins E Tratamento das hematurias pelo soro anti-bothropico. Actas Congr. amer. urol, B. Air. (1937) 1939, 2. Congr, 2: 346-52 —Loeper, M. Traitement des hematuries. In Ther. med. (Loeper, M.) Par, 1934, 7: 167-83—Plicque, A. F. Le traitement des hematuries. Bull. m6d. Par, 1908, 22: 1-3. --- in animals. Gtjetjgniatjd, G. J. *Le pissement de sang chez les bovins dans le Haut Morvan [Alfort] 64p. 8? Corbigny, 1928. Hennig, E. *Die Haematome der Pferde und ihre Behandlung [Bern] 40p. 8? Stuttg., 1900. Roger, J. *Essai de pathologie comparee au sujet de rhematurie vesicale chronique des bovides. 62p. 8? Par., 1910. Arguments in favour of the theory that plants containing oxalic acid are the cause of haematuria in cattle. Vet. J, Lond, 1915, 71: 593-8.—Banerjee, N. N. Haematuria in cattle; successful treatment by lead acetate. Ind. Vet. J, 1940-41, 17: 301.—Bankier, J. C. Enzootic bovine haematuria, haematuria vesicalis; a means of controlling the bladder haemorrhage. Canad. J. Comp. M, 1941, 5: 247-9.—Barberis, S. Emorragia renale causa di morte in un cavallo. Gior. med. vet, 1929, 78: 861-7.—Beijers, J. A. [Hematuria in horse and cattle] Tschr. diergeneesk, 1933, 60: 474; 522.— Burnett, E. A. R. Chronic haematuria of cattle. Vet. Rec, Lond, 1937, 17: 953.—Datta, S. C. A. The etiology of enzootic bovine haematuria. Ibid, 1934, 14: 1356.—De Felice, T. L'ematuria afebrile nei bovini. Gior. Soc. Accad. vet. ital, 1904, 53: 607-702^—Detroye, J. V. Nouvelles recherches sur la nature et la pathogenie de l'hematurie essentielle du bceuf. Limousin med, Limoges, 1902, 26: 14; 36; 61. ------ A propos de l'interpretation de M. Moussu; mise au point et fin deal discussion. Bull. Soc. centr. med. vet. Par, 1904, 58: 442-9.—Evers. Die rationelle Behandlung des Blutharnens der Rinder. Berl. tierarztl. Wschr, 1903, 10: 793-7. Behandlung des Blutharnens der Rinder mit Trypanblau nach Theiler. Ibid., 1913, 29: 436.—Fleming, R. H, Fowler, F. L., & Clark, R. H. Haematuria vesicalis. Canad. J. Res, 1930, 3: 125-9.—Glockner, E., & Haupt, H. Beitrag zum Stallrot (Haematurie) der Rinder. Munch, tierarztl. Wschr, 1922, 73: 161-5.—Hadwen, S. Bovine haematuria. J. Comp. Path, Edinb, 1918, 31: 64-70.—Jakimov, V. L. [Causes of hematuria in cattle in S. S. S. R.] Mikrob. J, Leningr, 1929, 8: 51-7.—Lafond & Mathis. Hemorragie renale chez une vache. Bull. Soc. sc. v6t. Lyon, 1899, 2: 5.—Miyamoto, T. Haematuria of native cattle in Formosa. Taiwan igakkai zasshi 1928, 56-62.—Moussu. Sur l'hematurie des betes bovines. BuU. Soc. centr. med. vet. Par, 1904, 58: 222-7.— Reid, H. A. Haematuria in a bull following rupture of renal vessels. Vet. Rec, Lond, 1904-5, 17: 611.—Schlegel, M. Die Stallrotkrankheit des Rindes (Haematuria chronica bovis) Munch, tierarztl. Wschr, 1934, 85; passim, 2 pl.—Scott, W. An interesting case of haematuria renalis, the result of umbilical infection in a young colt. Vet. Rec, Lond, 1902-3, 15: 781.— Taylor, H. Two cases of haematuria of obscure origin in the horse. Vet. J, Lond, 1923, 79: 31.—Westermann. Meine Erfahrungen uber das Blutharnen der Rinder und seme Be- handlung mit Damholid (Evers) Berl. tierarztl. Wschr, 1905, 880.—Zettler, J. Zur Aetiologie und Therapie des Stallrots (Haematuria vesicalis) der Rinder. Mitt. Verein. badisch. Tieriirzte, 1927, 27: 85; 94. --- in childhood. Carew-Shaw, E. Haematuria in childhood associated with acute mastoiditis. Brit. M. J, 1933, 1: 780.—Frankel, W. K. Hamaturie beim Kind. Kinderarztl. Prax, 1932, 3: 259-65 — Hanau, G. Ematurie infantili. Gazz. osp, 1934, 55: 1189- 91.—Nobecourt. Sur un garcon de 5 ans ayant prtsente des hematuries persistants depuis la fin de sa premiere annee. Progr. med. Par, 1939, pt 2, 1145-55.—Parkinson, J. P. Haematuria in infants and young children. Brit. J. Child. Dis. 1907 4: 37-42.—Pivani, A. L'ematuria nei bambino. Pediat. med. prat. Tor, 1933, 8: 43-52.—Rinaldi, R. Su le ematurie nell'infanzia. Arch. Soc. ital. chir, 1931, 37: 703-6. Rosenbaum, S. Hamaturie beim Kind. Kinderarztl. Prax, 1933, 4: 361—Schippers, J. C. [Hematuria in children] Mschr. kindergeneesk, 1931, 1: 10-21, 2 pl—Waller, R. G, & Paterson, D. Persistent haematuria. Brit. J. Child. Dis., 1935, 32: 51.—Weiner, S. B., & Schwarz, H. Addis count and failure of orthotolidine test in cases of hematuria in chil- dren. Am. J. Dis. Child, 1941, 61: 64-71—Williams, C. Hasmaturia in childhood. Med. Press & Circ, Lond, 1901, n. aer, 72:429-31. ---- in pregnancy. Botjman, N. W. *Haematuria in graviditate [Amsterdam] 72p. 8? Rotterd., 1901. Vitotjt, G. Contribution a l'etude des hematuries de la grossesse. 56p. 8? Par., 1906. Albanese, A. Considerazioni a proposito di tre casi di ematuria in gravidanza. Ann. ostet. gin, 1932, 54: 1117.— Bazan, J. Hematurias durante el embarazo. Sem. med, B. Air, 1926, 33: pt 2, 291-4.—Brakemann, O. Blutungen aus den oberen Harnwege klinisch unbekannter Ursache wahrend der Schwangerschaft. Zbl. Gyn, 1938, 62: 182-80.— Ematuria in gravidanza. Gazz. osp, 1935, 56: 1029-31.— Giuliani, G. M. Ematuria da ureterite cistica in gravidanza. Arch. ital. urol, 1935, 12: 463-74.—Grosse, A. Les hematuries de la grossesse. Rev. mens. gyn. obst. pediat. Par, 1910, 5: 143-9. Also Rev. med. Normandie, 1910, 145-51.—Lepoutre, C. • Hematuries graves au cours de la grossesse, avec coli- bacillose peu importante par ailleurs; guerison apr£s trans- fusion du sang et lavage des bassinets. Bull. Soc. fr. urol, 1935, 233-5. Also J. urol. med. Par, 1935, 40: 67-9.— Marta, A. Ematuria d'origine probabilemente endocrina complicante gravidanza settimestre in soggetto con esostosi multiple. Rass. ostet, 1935, 44: 105-11.—Papaconstantinidis. Hematurie de la grossesse ou hematurie gravidique. Grece med, Syra, 1903, 5: 38-40.—Swanson, C. N. Hematuria as a symptom of pregnancy hydronephrosis; report of case. J. Am. M. Ass, 1929, 93: 1551.—Thumim, L. Hamaturie bei Frauen. Zschr. Urol, 1909, 3: 505-32.—Treub,V. Zwanger- schapshaematurie. Ned. tschr. geneesk. 1912, 2: 900-6. HEMEL-HEMPSTEAD. West Herts Infir- mary. Annual reports. 50.-58., 1876-84. HEMERALOPIA [including Nyctalopia] See also Blindness; Retina, Adaptation; Vision. Betke. Die Nachtblindheit. Arbeitsschutz, 1940, 82 — Cantamessa, G. II fenomeno dell'occhio al buio e la visione crepuscolare. Boll, ocul, 1938, 17: 492.—Feldman, J. B. Dark adaptation, night blindness and glaucoma. Arch. Ophth, Chic, 1939, 22: 595-607.—Holcomb, R. C. Night blindness. J. Am. M. Ass, 1934, 102: 787.—Lagrange, H. Les petites hesperanopies. Ann. ocul. Par, 1930, 167: 744-61. Les amblyopies crepusculaires. Sem. hop. Paris, 1931, 7: 153-5.—Lourie, 6. R. Confusion in the usage of the words hemeralopia and nyctalopia. Am. J. Ophth, 1938, 3. ser, 21: 562.—Poyales, F. El sindrome de Hubbenet-Bitot. Med. ibera, 1927, 21: 391.—Segadas Vianna, H. Hemeralopia transitoria. Brasil med, 1941, 55: 305.—Tansley, K. Night blindness. Brit. J. Ophth, 1939, 23: 161-70.—Terrien, F. Hemeralopies et amblyopies toxiques. Progr. med. Par, 1939, pt 2, 1114; 1119.—Ugon, R. A. Hemeralopia escencial. Bol. Soc. med. quir. centr, Montev, 1939, 6: No. 26-27, 91.— Valle y Aldabalde, R. Hemeralopia y nictalopia. Siglo med, 1927, 79: 165-8. ---- Diagnosis. See also Retina, Adaptation: Measurement. Chantraine, H. Zur Prufung des Dunkelsehvermogens; Dunkelseh-Pruftafel und Adaptometer. Rontgenpraxis, 1938, 10: 395-8. ------ & Cramer. Zur Prufung des Dunkelseh- vermogens. Ibid, 1937, 9: 329-36.—Dashevsky, A. I. [New apparatus for examination of dark adaptation and determina- tion of simulation of hemeralopia] Vest, oft, 1937, 11: 651-8.— Feldman, J. B. Dark adaptation as a clinical test; the technic and the results. Arch. Ophth, Chic, 1936, 15: 1004; 1937, 17: 648.—Godding, E. W. Testing night vision. Brit. M. J, 1941, 2: 631; 789.—Hanum, S. [Defects in determining vision in darkness by means of light, clarity and form] Ugeskr. laeger, 1936, 98: 1213.—Harman, N. B. Testing night vision. Brit. M. J, 1941, 1: 636; 2: 347; 737; 858.—Heinsius, E. Ein Untersuchungsraum zur Prufung der Dunkelanpassung bei Reihenuntersuchungen. Deut. Militararzt, 1938, 3: 521-3.— Kline, E. M. The determination of night blindness by the use of the biophotometer. Univ. Hosp. Bull, Ann Arb, 1937, 3: §3—Metcalfe, E. E. A new method for determining night blindness; a preliminary report. U. S. Nav. M. Bull, 1940, 38: 231-9.—Nylund, C. E. [Principles for determining night blindness as a symptom of A-avitaminosis] Nord. med, 1939, 2: 1754; 1940, 8: 2527. ------ [Principles in determining night-blindness as symptom of vitamin-A deficiency] Ibid, 1940 8: 2345-8. Also Nutrit. Abstr, Aberdeen, 1941-42, 11: 303 —Piatt, R. J., & Griffis, L. E. Report on test for night visual efficiency. Flight Surgeon Topics, 1938, 2: 90-3.— Porter, H. B., Carlson, W. A, & Henton, H. C. A dark adapta- tion test applied to aviators. J. Aviat. M, 1937, 8: 62-6.— Raiaconal. K. Dark-adaptation tests in cases of clinical night- blindness. Ind. J. M. Res, 1941 29: 351-60^Riddell, W. J. B. Two clinical tests for night blindness. Tr. Ophth. hoc, U. K, 1940 60- 181-93.—Shepherd, J. A. Night blindness; a simple dark adaptation test. J. R. Nav. M. Serv,, 1940, 26: 253-62 .- Test—for nocturnal visual efficiency. Flight Surgeon 1 opics, 1938 2- 74-5, pl.—Vanzant, T. J. Night blindness as de- termined by the biophotometer. Texas J. M, 1938-39, 34: 23i_5 —Visual field and glare sensitivity tests for motor car drivers. Am. J. Optometr, 1939, 16: 416-8-Vraa-Jensen, G F [Method in adjusting hemeralopia tables] Ugeskr. laeger, 1936, 98: 859-62—Zaionchkovsky, MU. [Purkinje s phenomenon in the diagnosis of hemeralopia] Vrach. gaz, 1930, 34: 1817-20, HEMERALOPIA 488 HEMERALOPIA ---- epidemic. Birnbacher, T. Die epidemische Mangelhemeralopie; ein Reitrag zur Lehre von den Avitaminosen. Abh. Augenh, 1927, H. 4, 1-02. Also Med. Klin, Berl, 1927, 23: 266. Also Wien. klin. Wschr, 1927, 40: 105. Also Wien. med. Wschr, 1927, 77: 129. ------ Ueber den Fruhlingsgipfel der epidemischen Mangelhemeralopie und die pathogenetische Bedeutung des Fruhjahrs. Wien. klin. Wschr, 1928, 41: 698-700.—Laforgue. Rapport fait k la Societe de medecine de Toulouse, sur un memoire de M. le docteur Armieux, intitule: De l'hemeralopie epidemique. J. med. Toulouse, 1863, 4. ser, 2: 233-8.—Outbreak of night-blindness. Lancet, Lond, 1942, 1: 121.—Wittenberg, T. [Hemeralopia aestivalis] Norsk, mag. lssgevid, 1928, 89: 228-31.—Wright, W. D. Testing night vision. Brit. M. J, 1941, 1: 795. ---- Etiology. See also Deficiency disease; Liver, Disease, &c. Baevsky, I. L. [Etiology and treatment of functional hemeralopia] Vest, oft, 1941, 18: 261-7.—Kalkutina, M. L. [Dark adaptation in affections of the optic nerve] Ibid, 254- 60.—KoIacny\ J. [Disturbances of the functions of the liver and its relation to the decrease in adaptation of the eye to darkness] Bratisl. lek. listy, 1938, 18: 358; 398.—Lagrange, H. L'amblyopie crepusculaire; classification de ses formes eti- ologiques. Bull. Soc. opht. Paris, 1929, 472-664. Les formes cliniques etiologiques de l'amblyopie crepusculaire aigue. Ann. ocul. Par, 1930, 167: 652-77.—Thorvardsson, A. K. Studies of the correlation between acquired hemeralopia and neuroses. Nutrit. Abstr, Aberdeen, 1941—42. 11: 304.— Wohl, M. G, & Feldman, J. B. Vitamin A deficiency in dis- eases of the thyroid gland; its detection by dark adaptation. Tr. Am. Ass. Goiter, 1938, 460-6.—Wood, D. J. The Doyne memorial lecture; night blindness in eye disease; suggestions and speculations. Tr. Ophth. Soc. U. K, 1938, 57: 469-93 — Zaffke, K. H. Hemeralopie als Symptom bei Thyreotoxikosen und Lebererkrankungen. Deut. Arch. klin. Med, 1938-39, 183: 433-47. Also Zhl. inn. Med, 1939. 60: 374-8. ---- Frequency. Abramson, E, & Oigaard, H. The prevalence of dys- adaptation in public elementary schools for children at Djurs- holm. Skand. Arch. Physiol, Berl, 1939, 82: 49-60.—Basu, N. M, & De, N. K. Assessment of vitamin A deficiency amongst Bengalees and determination of the minimal and optimal requirements of vitamin A by a simplified method for measuring visual adaptation in the dark. Ind. J. M. Res, 1941, 29: 591-612.—Choussat, H. Cas typique d'avitaminose A; syndrome de Bitot (hemeralopie+xirosis conjonctival) avec troubles de la croissance; frequence de cette avitaminose chez les indigenes. Algerie med, 1941, 4. ser, 45: 155-8.— Ehlers, H. Ein tausend Hemeralopieuntersuchungen. Acta ophth, Kbh, 1937, 15: 443-56.—Goiter, F. J. [Experimental examinations for night-blindness] Geneesk. tschr. Ned. Indie, 1939, 79: 1181-92, pl.—Goss, G. C. L, Farmer, F. A, & McFarlane, W. D. A comparison of dark adaptation; bio- photometer tests on French and English school children in a Quebec community. Canad. M. Ass. J, 1941, 44: 30-3.— Hunt, E. P. Medical evaluation of nutritional status; dark adaptation of high school children at different income levels. Milbank Mem. Fund Q, 1941, 19: 252-81.—Joachimoglu, G., & Logaras, G. Ueber das Vorkommen von Nachtblindheit bei Mann und Weib. Deut. med. Wschr, 1933, 59: 1043.— Lerner, H. H. Biophotometric measurements of dark adapta- tion among roentgenologists; a measure of vitamin A deficiency. Am. J. Roentg, 1941, 45: 753-5.—Lewis, J. M, & Haig, C. Vitamin A status of children as determined by dark adaptation. J. Pediat, S. Louis, 1940, 16: 285-96.—McKenzie, A. Night blindness and vitamin A in African school boys. East Afr. M. J, 1938-39, 15: 143-7. ------ An examination of vitamin A deficiency among African natives by the visual dysadaptation test. Tr. R. Soc. Trop. M. Hyg, Lond, 1938-39, 32: 717-28 — Rapaport, H. G, & Greenberg, D. Avitaminosis A; incidence in a group of 100 hospitalized children as measured by the biophotometer. N. York State J. M, 1941, 41: 879.—Staz, L. Vitamin A deficiency and night blindness in Bantu mine workers on the Witwatersrand. S. Afr. J. M. Sc, 1937, 2: 143-50.— Yarbrough, M. E, & Dann, W. J. Dark adaptometer and blood vitamin A measurements in a North Carolina nutrition survey. J. Nutrit, 1941, 22: 597-607. ---- Heredity. Barbieri, A. La hemeralopia idiop&tica familiar o ceguera nocturna en la degeneration corio-capilar. Prensa med argent, 1929-30, 16: 1247-55.—Dieter, W. Untersuchungen zur Duplizitiitstheorie; die angeborene, familiar-erbliche, Btationare (idiopathische) Hemeralopie. Arch, ges Physiol 1929, 222: 381-94.—[Discussion on I. L. Vibek's paper: 3 cases of hereditary hemeralopy] Hospitalstidende, 1937, 80: [Oftal selsk. forh.] 14.—Habs, H. Zur Erbbedingtheit der Dunkel- adaptation. Zschr. indukt. Abstamm, 1937, 73: 531.— Lis Vibek, I. [Case of hereditary hemeralopia] Ugeskr laeeer 1936, 98: 1024-20— Riddell, W. J. B. A pedigree of hereditary stationary sex-linked night blindness. Ann. Eugen.. Cambr 1940, 10:326-31. ' ---- Military, and public safety aspect. Codvelle, F. L'hemeralopie epidemique avitaminose dea armees de campagne. Rev. med. fr, 1938, 19: 347-55.— Cvetojeviich, M. [Essential hemeralopia in the Yugoslavian Army] Voj. san. glasnik, 1936, 7: 23-45.—Feldman, J. B. Dark adaptation; its place in accident prevention. Indust. M, 1940, 9: 158-61.—Heinsius, E. Zur Frage der sogenannten Kriegshemeralopie. Med. Welt, 1941, 15: 341-7.—Hoff, H. [Hemeralopia] Militaerla>gen, 1935. 41: 213-6.—Jeghers, H. Night blindness due to vitamin A deficiency: a consideration of its importance in traffic problems. N. England J. M, 1937, 216: 51-6.—Night blindness a cause of accidents; its causes and cure. Good Health, 1937, 72: 81.—Night blindness may be cause of auto accidents. Science News Lett, 1938, 33: 331.—Rollet, J. Accidents d'automobile et hemeralopie Arch, opht. Par, 1934, 51: 73-5. Also Bull. Soc. opht. Paris, 1934, 48-50. Nyctalopia [Day-blindness] Schweiz See also Glare; Photophobia. Goldmann, H. Zum Problem der Nyktalopie. med. Wschr, 1936, 66: 1127-9. ---- Oguchi type. Bein, K, & Michniewicz, L. Ist die Oguchische Krankheit ausschliesslich an die mongolische Rasse gebunden? Klin. Mbl. Augenh, 1932, 89: 640-2.—Ehara, Y. On the velocity of the dark adaptation of retinal rods in Oguchi's disease. Acta Soc. ophth. jap, 1939, 43: 55.—Endelman, L. Zweiter und dritter Fall von Oguchischer Krankheit in Europa. Klin. Mbl. Augenh, 1931, 87: 798-801.—Franceschetti, A., & Chome- Bercioux, N. Fundus albipunctatus cum hemeralopia. Arch. opht. Par, 1939, n. ser, 3: 598.—Fuchs, A. Ein Fall von weiss- punktiertem Fundus bei Hemeralopie mit Xerose. Klin. Mbl. Augenh, 1928, 81: 849.—Granstrom, K. O. [Oguchi's disease] Hygiea, Stockh, 1936, 98: 721.------ Ein Fall von Oguchis Krankheit in Schweden. Klin. Mbl. Augenh, 1937, 98: 77-9.— Imai, R. [Ueber die idiopatische Hemeralopie, wobei zahllose weisse Punktchen im Augenhintergrund vorhanden sind] Acta Soc. ophth. jap, 1941, 45: 709-13.—Jess, A. Zur Frage der Augenhintergrundsbefunde bei Nachtblindheit. Zschr. Augenh, 1933-34, 82: 177-80.—Klien, B. A. A case of so-called Oguchi'a disease in the U. S. A. Am. J. Ophth, 1939, 3. ser, 22: 953- 5, pl.—Oguchi, C. Weitere Mitteilung iiber die Oguchische Krankheit. Arch. Ophth, Berl, 1926, 117: 208-18. Also Tr. Internat. Ophth. Congr. (1929) 1930, 13. Congr, 2: 609, Also Abstr.—Otuka, J. Ueber die sogenannten Zapfendunkel- adaptation von Oguchischer Krankheit. Acta Soc. ophth. jap, 1939, 43: 150.—Scheerer, R. Fall von Oguchischer Krankheit mit Mizuoschem Phanomen. Ber. Deut. ophth. Ges, 1927, 46: 442. —----• Der erste sichere Fall von Oguchischer Krank- heit mit Mizuoschem Phanomen ausserhalb Japans (ange- borene Nachtblindheit mit weissgrauer Verfiirbung des Augen- hintergrundes, die nach langerem Dunkelaufenthalt verschwin- det) Klin. Mbl. Augenh, 1927, 78: 811-3.—Uyemura, M. Ueber eine merkwiirdige Augenhintergrundveranderung bei zwei Fallen von idiopathischer Hemeralopie. Ibid, 1928, 81: 471-3, pl. ---- Pathogenesis. See also Retina, Metabolism; Visual purple. Calleya, J. M. *A hemeralopia principal- mente considerada com relagao & sua etiologia e therapeutica. 66p. 8? Lisb., 1870. Wohlfarth, O. *Zur Frage der Hemeralopie. 16p. 8? Frankf. a. M., 1917. Tansley, K. The regeneration of visual purple; its relation to dark adaptation and night blindness. J. Physiol, Lond, 1931, 71: 442-58.—Thordarson, V. Self-experimentation in artificially produced night-blindness. Acta ophth, Kbh, 1939, 17:477-81. ---- Pathogenesis: Hypothesis of vitamin de- ficiency. See also Vitamin A, Deficiency. Edmund, C, & Clemmesen, S. On deficiency of A vitamin and visual dysaptation. Pts 1-2. 92p.; 51p. 8? Lond., 1936-37. Frandsen, H. Hemeralopia as an early criterion of A-avitaminosis and clinical symptoms and treatment of this disease. 160p. 8? Kbh., 1935. Also Bibl. laeger, 1936, 128: 77-81. Adler, F. H. Clinical aspects of vitamin A and dark adapta- tion. Arch. Ophth, Chic, 1940, 23: [Discussion] 876-8 — Baum, W. S, & McCoord, A. B. The relationship between biophotometer tests and the vitamin A content of the blood of children. J. Pediat, S. Louis, 1940, 16: 409-18.—Blanchard, E. L, & Harper, H. A. Measurement of vitamin A status of young adults by the dark adaptation technic. Arch. Int. M, HEMERALOPIA 489 HEMERALOPIA 1940, 66: 661-9.—Bodanksy, O, Lewis, J. M., & Haig, C. The comparative value of the blood plasma vitamin A concentration and the dark adaptation as a criterion of vitamin A deficiency. Science, 1941, 94: 370.—Caussade, L., Thomas, C. [et al.] L'hemeralopie dans l'hypovitaminose A provoquee. Bull. Soc. opht. Paris, 1938, 276-81. ------ Utilisation du test d'hemera- lopie pour le depistage des etats d'hypovitaminose A chez l'enfant. Ibid, 415-7.—Corlette, M. B, Youmans, J. B. [et al.] Photometric studies of visual adaptation in relation to mild vitamin A deficiency in adults. Am. J. M. Sc, 1938, 195: 54-65.—Correa Borquez, O. El test fotometrico en la hipo- vitaminosis A; metodos de determinaci6n de vitamina A; hemeralopia; purpura visual; classificaci6n; estudios foto- metricos; crltica a algunos aparatos. Rev. chilena pediat, 1940, 11: 732-59.—Dann, J, & Yarbrough, M. Some observa- tions on dark adaptation and vitamin A metabolism. J. Elisha Mitchell Sc. Soc, 1941, 57: 201.------ Dark adaptometer readings of subjects on a diet deficient in vitamin A. Arch. Ophth, Chic, 1941, 25: 833-8.—Dark adaptation and vitamin A. J. Am. M. Ass, 1941, 117: 370.—Fisher, O. E. Severe night blindness due to vitamin A deficiency. Brit. M. J, 1938, 2: 944.—Frandsen, H. [Examination of hemeralopia in deficiency of vitamin A] Hospitalstidende, 1934, 77: (med. selsk. forh.) 42-8.—Fridericia, L. S, & Holm, E. [On the occurrence of hemeralopia together with xerophthalmia and the influence of vitamin A insufficiency in food on the regeneration of the visual purple] Bibl. laeger, 1923, 115: 441-72.—Getz, H. R, Hildebrand, G. B., & Finn, M. Vitamin A deficiency in normal and tuberculous persons, as indicated by the biopho- tometer. J. Am. M. Ass, 1939, 112: 1308-11.—Granit, R. [Visual purple, sensitivity to light and vitamin A; the inter- mediate process in dark adaptation] Nord. med, 1939, 3: 2700-9.— Gridgemen, N. T., & Wilkinson, H. Night-blindness and vitamin A deficiency; the use of the biophotometer. Lancet, Lond, 1938, 1: 905-7.—Harris, L. J, & Abbasy, M. A. The dark-adaptation test; its reliability as a test for vitamin-A deficiency. Ibid, 1939, 2: 1299; 1355.—Harris, R, & Owen, G. W. Night blindness and vitamin deficiency as evidenced by the new biophotometer. Mississippi Doctor, 1939-40, 17: 334-6.—Haurowitz, F. Vitamin A und Sehpurpur; ein Beitrag zur Kenntnis der Hemeralopie. Med. Klin, Berl, 1933, 29: 1148.—Hecht, S. Vitamin A and vision. Arch. Ophth, Chic, 1940, 23: 874-6. ------ & Mandelbaum, J. Dark adaptation and experimental human vitamin A deficiency. Am. J. Physiol, 1940, 130: 651-64.—Henry, L. M. J. Night- blindness and vitamin A. Brit. M. J, 1941, 1: 572.—Hunt, E. P, & Palmer, C. E. Medical evaluation of nutritional status; measurement of visual dark adaptation with the adaptometer. Milbank Mem. Fund Q, 1940, 18: 403-24.—Isaacs, B. L, Jung, F. T., & Ivy, A. C. Vitamin A deficiency and dark adaptation. J. Am. M. Ass, 1938, 111: 777-80. ------ Clinical studies of vitamin A deficiency; biophotometer and adaptometer, Hecht, studies on normal adults and on persons in whom an attempt was made to produce vitamin A deficiency. Arch. Ophth, Chic, 1940, 24: 698-721.—Jeans, P. C, Blan- chard, E. L, & Satterthwaite, F. E. Dark adaptation and vitamin A; further studies with the biophotometer. J. Pediat, S. Louis, 1941, 18: 170-94.—Jeans, P. C, Blanchard, E, & Zentmire, Z. Dark adaptation and vitamin A. J. Am. M. Ass, 1937, 108: 451-8.—Jeghers, H. Night blindness as a criterion of vitamin A deficiency; review of the literature with preliminary observations of the degree and prevalence of vitamin A deficiency among adults in both health and disease. Ann. Int. M, 1936-37, 10: 1304-34, 4 figs.—Josephs, H. W. Vitamin A; a comparison of dark adaptation time and serum vitamin A level. Am. J. Dis. Child, 1940, 60: 769.—Lewis, J. M, & Haig, C. Vitamin A requirements in infancy as deter- mined by dark adaptation. J. Pediat, S. Louis, 1939, 15: 812-23.—Mandelbaum, J, & Hecht, S. Dark adaptation under controlled dietary vitamin A conditions. Am. J. Physiol, 1940, 129: 416.—Manville, I. A. Nutrition and night blindness. Northwest M, 1939, 38: 208-13.—Mathis, G. Avitaminosi A ed emeralopia; ricerche su 500 scolari di Torino. Rass. ital. ottalm, 1939, 8: 353-78.—Palmer, C. E. The use of a dark adaptation technique (biophotometer) in the measurement of vitamin A deficiency in children. Pub. Health Rep, Wash, 1937, 52: 1403-19. ------ The dark adaptation test for vitamin A deficiency. Am. J. Pub. Health, 1938, 28: 309-15 — Park, I. O. Preliminary observations on vitamin A deficiency as shown by studies with the visual photometer. J. Oklahoma M. Ass, 1935, 28: 357; 1936, 29: 129.—Pett, L. B, & LePage, G. A. Vitamin A deficiency; blood analysis correlated with a visual test. J. Biol. Chem, 1940, 132: 585-93. Also repr — Pies, R., & Wendt, H. Untersuchungen iiber Hemeralopie; ein Beitrag zu der Frage des Vorkommens von Vitamin A- Mangelzustanden. Klin. Wschr, 1939, 18: 429-31— Schuck, C, & Miller, W. O. Dark adaptation of the eye and vitamin A storage in young adults. Arch. Int. M, 1938, 61: 910-5.— Sheard, C, Bair, H. L., & Steffens, L. F. Dark adaptation and dietary vitamin A deficiency. Am. J. Physiol, 1940, 129: 461.—Sheftel, A. G. Dark adaptation and vitamin A deficiency; a new technic. Am. J. Clin. Path, 1940, 10: 168-75—Snelling, C. E. A study of the Birch-Hirschfeld photometric test for vitamin A deficiency. J. Pediat, S. Louis, 1936, 9: 655; 1938, 13: 506.—Steffens, L. F. Vitamin A and night blindness. Am. J. M. Sc, 1939, 198: 292-300. ------ Bair, H. L., & Sheard, C. Photometric measurements on visual adaptation in normal adults on diets deficient in vitamin A. Proc. Mayo CUn, 1939,14: 698-704. ------Dark adaptation and dietary deficiency m vitamin A. Am. J. Ophth, 1940, 23: 1325-40. Also Arch Ophth Chic, 1940, 24: 851-3.—Steininger, G, & Roberts, L. J. Biophotometer test as index on nutritional status for vitamin A. Arch. Int. M, 1939, 63: 1170-86 Also rePrf~.Ve/bit9Jkaia' ?•• A' & Litvak> L L [Adaptation as a method for determining primary and secondary A-hypovi- taminoses] Khn. med, Moskva, 1940, 18: No. 4 53-6 — Wagman, I. H, & Gullberg, J. E. Effect of vitamin A deficiency upon rate of pupil dilation during dark adaptation. Proc. Soc. Exp. Biol, N. Y, 1938, 38: 613-5.—Wald, G., Jeghers. H, & Arminio, J. An experiment in human dietary night-blindness. Am. J Physiol, 1938, 123: 732-46.—Wilbur, D. L., & Euster- man, G. B. Probable nutritional night blindness: report of a case. Proc. Mayo Clin, 1933, 8: 457-60. Also J. Am. M. Ass, 1934, 102: 364-6. Also repr.—Yudkin, S. Dark-adaptation tests and vitamin A deficiency. Brit. M. J, 1941, 2: 747. ------ Vitamin A and dark-adaptation; effect of alcohol] benzedrine and vitamin C. Lancet, Lond, 1941, 2: 787-91. ----- Physiopathology. Adler, F. H, & McDonald, R. The effect of anoxemia on dark adaptation in the normal and vitamin A deficient subject. Tr. Am. Ophth. Soc, 1939, 37: 368-78.—Budanov, S. F. [Purkinje's phenomenon in hemeralopia] Kazan, med. J, 1939, 35: No. 5-6, 90-4.—Charpentier, G. The electrical retinal responses of normal and hemeralopie (A-deficient) rats. Acta ophth, Kbh, 1936, 14: 25-7.—Edmund, C. On erythropia and xanthopsia in hemeralopia. Ibid, 1927, 5: 88-98.—Korb, J. H. Perception time and night-blindness. U. S. Nav. M. Bull, 1939, 37: 392-9.—McDonald, R, & Adler, F. H. Effect of anoxemia on the dark adaptation of the normal and of the vitamin-A-deficient subject. Arch. Ophth, Chic, 1939, 22: 980-8.—Shibaev, A. V. [Light sense-and dark adapta- tion in essential hemeralopia] Tr. Acad. mil. med. Kiroff, 1936, 2: 174-80.—Tagami, M. [Ueber die Einfliisse der vorausgegan- genen Belichtung auf den Verlauf der Dunkeladaptation bei angeborener, stationarer Hemeralopie im engeren Sinne] Acta Soc. ophth. jap, 1941, 45: 39-47.—Uyemura, M. Ueber den Schwellenwert des Zapfens bei der idiopathischen Hemera- lopie. Klin. Mbl. Augenh, 1928, 81: 186-91. ---- pregnancy. Edmund, C, & Clemmesen, S. On parenteral A vitamin treatment of dysaptatio (nyctalo-hemeralopia) in some preg- nant women. Acta med. scand, 1936, 89: 69-92.—Juhasz- Schaffer, A. Schwangerschaftshemeralopie und A-Vitamin. Klin. Wschr, 1938, 17: 407-9.—Kentgens, S. K. Ueber den Zusammenhang von Schwangerschaft, Storung der Dunkel- adaptation und dem Vitamin A-Gehalt des Blutes. Acta ophth, Kbh, 1938, 16: 332-43. ----- Psychological aspect. Culpin, M. Night-blindness; a psychologicl study. Brit. M. J, 1942, 1: 23.—Hattingberg, I. von, & Buchholz, F. Untersuchungen iiber die Ermiidbarkeit des Dunkelsehens an Gesunden und Kranken. Arch. Psychiat, Berl, 1937, 107: 412.—Walshe, F. M. R. Night-blindness; a psychological study. Brit. M. J, 1941, 2: 858 —Wittkower, E, Rodger, T. F. [et al.] Night-blindness; a pjycho-physiological study. Ibid, 571; 607. ----- Treatment. Andel, M. A. van [Liver tissue in treatment of night blind- ness] Ned. tschr. geneesk, 1925, 69: 599-601.—Barondes, R. de R. Glycerol trinitrate (nitroglycerine) in the treatment of hemeralopia (night-blindness) Brit. J. Ophth, 1936, 20: 528-31. ------ Night blindness; its treatment with vasodi- lating drugs. Med. Rec, N. Y, 1941, 154: 427.—Barrere, H. Hemeralopie; guerie par les fumigations de foie de mouton. J. med. Toulouse, 1855, 2. ser, 5: 70.—Frandsen, H. [Local treatment of the eye for hemeralopia with cod-liver-oil and carotin] Hospitalstidende, 1938, 81: [oft. selsk. forh.] 17.— Gorczycki, Z. A propos d'un cas d'hemeralopie traitee par le Redoxon. Schweiz. med. Wschr, 1937, 67: 250-3—Har- greaves, J. M. A protection against night blindness. Flight Surgeon Topic, 1938, 2: 151.—Siebert, H. B. Die Behandlung der idiopathischen Nachtblindheit. Med. Welt, 1930, 4: 995.— Vaillant, C, & Gillis, L. Night-blindness treated with vitamin A. Lancet, Lond, 1939, 1: 149. ----- in animals. Craft, W. A. Night blindness in cattle. J. Hered, 1927, 18: 215 —Jacob, S. Night-blindness or hemeralopia. Ind. Vet. J, 1940, 17: 157-60.—Yoshiue, S. Ueber das Verhalten des Sehpurpurs bei avitaminbsen Tieren. Arch. Augenh., 1924, 95: 140-2. HEMERY, Haydn. The physiological basis of the art of singing, xviii, 139p. incl. diagr. 22cm. Lond., H. K. Lewis & Co., 1939. HEMERYTHRIN. See also Blood, Pigments; Cytochrome; Res- piration. HEMERYTHRIN 490 HEMIANOPSIA Florkix, M. *Recherches sur les hdmdry- thrines. 82r . 8? Liege, 1933. Also Arch, internat. physio), Liege, 1933, 36: 247-328. Florkin, M. Sur les hemerythrines; absence de combinaison avec I'oxvde de carbone, separation du fer, point isoeiectrique. C. rend. *Soc. biol, 1933, 112: 207. ------ Courbe de dis- sociation de l'oxyhemerythrine et equation de Hill. Ibid, 295-7. ------ Sur la fonction de I'hemerythrine. Ibid, 706-8.—Marrian, G. F. A note on haemerythrin. Brit. J. Exp. Biol, 1926-27, 4: 357-64.—Roche, A, & Roche, J. Pression osmotique et poids moieculaire de I'hemerythrine du siponcle. Bull. Soc. chim. biol. Par, 1935, 17: 1494-508 — Roche, J. Sur l'hemerythrine du siponcle. Ibid, 1933, 15: 1415-35.------Sur le pigment respiratoire de hematies du siponcle (hemerythrine) C. rend. Soc. biol. Par, 1933, 112: 251-4. ------ Sur la composition de I'hemerythrine du siponcle. Ibid, 114: 1188. ------& Dubuoloz, P. Note sur le spectre visible et ultra-violet de I'hemerythrine du siponcle. Arch, internat. physiol, Liege, 1933, 37: 16-9. HEMI ... For subjects beginning with this prefix see also under main, unmodified nouns or words related to them as Pain, unilateral for Hemialgia; Cellulose, Derivatives for Hemicellulose, &c. HEMIALBUMOSE. See Hemiproteose. HEMIANESTHESIA. See also Anesthesia; Babinski-Nageotte syn- drome; also names of primary diseases. Cremieux, A. Les hemianesthesies. Marseille med, 1926, 63: 1605-35.—Divry. Un cas d'hemianesthesie alterne. J. neur. psychiat, Brux, 1931, 31: 73-7.—Marinesco, G, Draganesco, S, & Sager, O. Hemianesthesie sensitive et sensorielle (anosmie, agueusie, cecite et surdite avec troubles labyrinthiques du m§me cote) d'origine fonctionnelle chez un organique. Rev. otoneur. Par, 1927, 5: 727-32.—Moniz, E. Un caiso de hemianestesia dissociada. J. Soc. sc. med. Lisbon, 1913, 77: No. 8-12, 119-32. HEMIANOPSIA. See also Alexia; Blindness; Scotoma; Visual field. Aschermann, H. F. W. H. *Rechtslinks- blindheit [Rostock] 18p. 8? Plauen, 1925. Evans, J. N. Hemianopsia. In Cyclop. Med. (Piersol- Bortz) Phila, 1939, 7: 208-11.—Holloway, T. B, & Wentworth, H. A. The occurrence of frank hemianopsia; perimetric studies of 2,500 cases. Ann. Surg, 1935, 101: 176-83. Also in Surgerv (Ravdin, I. S.) Phila, 1935, 176-83.—Lebensohn, J. E. Wollas- ton and hemianopsia. Am. J. Ophth, 1941, 24: 1053-6, portr.—Malbran, J, & Riega, E. de la. Sobre un caso de hemianopsia doble. Rev. As. m.ed. argent, 1936, 50: 2014—9.— Shepkalova, W. M. [Hemianopsia in the ophthalmologic clinic of Kuban Medical Institute] Sovet. vest, oft, 1932, 1: 258- 70.—Vampre, E. Estudio clinico das hemianopsias, baseado em 24 observacoes. Ann. Fac. med. S. Paulo, 1931, 6: 97-280. ---- binasal. Schulte, D. *Ueber binasale Hemianopsie. 29p. 8? Konigsb. Pr., 1938. Aguilar, J. Consideraciones sobre un caso de hemianopsia binasal. Med. ibera, 1932, 26:102-5.—Balado, M, & Malbran, J. Contribuci6n a la estructura del quiasma optico humano (hemianopsia binasal) Sem. med, B. Air, 1933, 40: pt 2, 797-807.—Baudouin, A, Halbron, P, & Deparis, M. L'hemi- anopsie binasale. Rev. neur. Par, 1934, 41: pt 2, 531-54.— Baurmann, M. Anatomische Untersuchung eines Falles von binasaler Hemianopsie. Arch. Ophth, Berl, 1931, 126: 203- 20.—Busacca Gorgone, A. Due caisi di emianopsia eteronima binasale da lesione del chiasma e della sella turcica senza sintomi di disfunzione ipofisaria. Lettura oft, 1926, 3: 600-21, pl.—Charamis, J. S. Hemianopsie binasale par tumeur de la region hypophysaire. Ann. ocul. Par, 1931, 168: 737-46.— Christiansen, V. LTne forme speciale de l'hemianopsie nasale. Acta ophth, Kbh, 1927, 5: 78-87.—Dejean, C. L'hemianopsie bi-nasale. Arch, opht. Par, 1930, 47: 218-28.------Un cas d'hemianopsie bi-nasale. Rev. otoneur. Par, 1931, 9: 28-31.—Espfldora Luque, C. Hemianopsia binasal. Arch. oft. hisp. amer, 1932, 32: 196.—Feigenbaum, A. Binasale Hemianopsie. Klin. Mbl. Augenh, 1926, 77: 517-21.— Hartmann, E. Hemianopsie binasale dans un cas de cecite post-hemorragique. Bull. Soc. opht. Paris, 1933, 347-50.— Heckel, E. B. Binasal hemianopsia. Am. J. Ophth, 1936, 3. Ber, 19: 336.—Lutz, A. Ueber binasale Hemianopsie; eine vergleichende Zusammenstellung von 84 Mitteilungen in der Literatur und Beschreibung zweier eigener Beobachtungen Arch. Ophth, Berl, 1927-28, 119: 423-87.------ Ueber einige weitere Falle von binasaler Hemianopsie (Bericht Uber eine neue eigone Beobachtung unter spezieller HeruckMchtigune der Pupillenrcaktion) Ibid, 1930, 125: 103-24.—Polzt, ()., & Urban, H. Leber die isoliert erhaltene temporale Sicliel bei zerebraler Hemianopsie. Mschr. Psychiat, 1935-36, 92: 67-106.—Rouquier, A, & Gault, A. Syndrome chiasmali- que; hemianopsie binasale; arachnoldite probable. Bull. Soc. opht. Paris, 1937, 253-5.— Schwab, S. I. Binasal hemianopsia J. Missouri M. Ass, 1929, 26: 592.- Seguini, A. Emianopsia binasale in affezioni luetiche della base. Riv. otoneur, 1927, 4: 299-304.—Torkildsen, A. [Binasal hemianopsia with tumor in the posterior cranial fossa] Norsk, mag. laegevid, 1938, 99; 1317-21.—Trettenero, A. Etiologia e patogenesi dell'enii' anopsia binasale: un caso prodolto da insolazione su "base luetica (terziaria) Ann. ottalm, 1930, 58:886-909.—Vlavianos, G. Ueber binasale Hemianopsie. Arch. Psychiat, Berl' 1932, 97: 207. ---- bitemporal. Adrogue, E. Sobre un caso de hemianopsia bitemporal por presion de la arteria cerebral anterior. Arch. oft. B. Aires 1939, 14: 999-1006.—Coppez, H. Hemianopsie bitemporal traumatique; evaluation de la depreciation permanente. Bull Soc. beige opht, 1928, No. 57, 122.—Coutela. Hemianopsie bitemporale par fracture du crane. Bull. Soc. chir. Paris, 1930, 22: 239-42.—Endelman, L. Zwei Falle plotzlich entstandener bitemporaler Hemianopsie mit unaufgeklarter Aetiologie (Friihsymptom von multipler Sklerose?) Zschr. Augenh, 1932, 78: 234.—Foix & Schiff-Wertheimer. Hemianopsies bitem- porales syphilitiques curables. Rev. otoneur. Par, 1926, 4- 174-7.—Henderson, J. W., & Rucker, C. W. Bitemporal hemianopia of traumatic origin. Arch. Ophth, Chic, 1940, 24: 800-2.—Okinczyc, J, & Renard, G. Un cas d'hemianopsie bitemporale par fracture du cr&ne. Bull. Soc. opht. Paris, 1927,262-5.—Osterberg, G. Traumatic bitemporal hemianopia (sagittal tearing of the optic chiasma) Acta ophth, Kbh, 1938, 16: 466-80.—Terrien, F. L'emianopsia bitemporale. Gior. ocul, 1928, 9: 97-9.—Veil, P. L'hemianopsie bitem- porale; le syndrome chiasmatique. Rev. gen. clin. ther, 1932, 46: 483.—Zondek, H. On the question of retrogression of bitemporal hemianopsia under internal therapy. Acta ophth. orient, 1938-39, 1: 88-91. ---- cortical. Adrogue, E. Contribuci6n al estudio de las hemianopsias corticales. Arch. oft. B. Aires, 1939, 14: 919-26.—Balado, M, Malbran, J., & Franke, E. Doble incongruencia hemian6psica de origen cortical. Arch, argent, neur, 1934, 10: 201—12.— Hymes, C. Hemianopsia with and without sparing of the macula in lesions of the visual cortex. Am. J. Ophth, 1938, 3. ser, 21: 670.—Schiff-Wertheimer, S. Estudio clinico dc los sindromes hemian6psicos de origen sylviano. Arch, med, Madr, 1927. 27: 481-5. ---- Diagnosis. Cantonnet, A. Semeiologie des hemianopsies. J. med. chir. Par, 1932, 103: 534-7.—Harrington, D. O. Localizing value of incongruity in defects in the visual fields. Arch. Ophth, Chic, 1939, 21: 453-64.—Kestenbaum, A. Zur topischen Diagnostik der Hemianopsie. Zschr. Augenh, 1931-32, 76: 241-77. ------ Wertung der neuen topischen Diagnostik der Hemianopsie. Tr. Internat. Ophth. Congr. (1937) 1938, 15. Congr, 4: Commun, 120-3.—Lauber, H. Die ophthalmoskopische Differentialdiagnose der infra- und supranuklearen Hemianopsie, zugleich ein Beitrag zur Topo- graphie der Faserverteilung in der Netzhaut. Ber. Deut. ophth. Ges, 1927, 46: 89-94 [Discussion] 116.—Pastore, K. I segni diagnostici differenziali nella emianopsia (reazione emianopica di Wernicke; persistenza della sensazione luminosa nei campo cieco emianopsico) Riv. otoneur, 1927, 4: 557- 662.—Skorodumova, A. V. [Clinical significance of the disk in hemianopsia] Vopr. neirokhir, 1940, 4: No. 3, 61-7.— Soriano, F. J. Reacci6n hemian6pica; tecnica y significaci6n. Arch, argent, neur, 1930, 6: 9-14. ---- Etiology. See also Arachnoid, Inflammation; Brain tumor; Cranium, Fracture; Head injury; Mi- graine; Optic chiasm; Pituitary, Tumor, &c. Schiff-Wertheimer, S. Les syndromes hemi- anopsiques dans le ramollissement cerebral. 155p. 8? Par., 1926. Ackroyd, C. H, & Eurich, F. W. Case of hemianopic paracentral scotoma following vascular lesion near posterior limb of internal capsule. Tr. Ophth. Soc. U. K, 1933, 53: 615-7.—Adie, W. J. Permanent hemianopia in migraine and subarachnoid haemorrhage. Lancet, Lond, 1930, 2: 237.— Arganaraz, R. Hemianopsias heteronimas y los tumores endo- craneanos vecinos del quiasma; su diagnostico, pronostico y tratamiento. Arch. oft. B. Aires, 1941, 16: 349-75.—Balado, M, Malbran, J, & Franke, E. Incongruencia hemian6psica derecha por lesion primitiva del cuerpo geniculado externo izquierdo (is6pteras internas) Arch, argent, neur, 1934, 11; HEMIANOPSIA 491 HEMIANOPSIA 143-51.—Beauvieux. Les hemianopsies transitoires par angiospasme. Rev. otoneur. Par, 1930, 8: 94-9.—Bourguet, J Vue d'ensemble sur les tumeurs endocraniennes determinant l'hemianopsie; leurs signes de localisation: en particulier sur les tumeurs perichiasmatiques. Ann. mal. oreille, 1927, 46: 1- 4g__Dejean, C, & Bonnahon, J. Deux cas d'hemianopsie chiasmatique consecutive k des traumatismes craniens non penetrants avec syndrome commotionnel tardif. Rev. otoneur. Par, 1932, 10: 670-8.—Esteban, M. A prop6sito de un caso de doble hemianopsia consecutive a herida de guerra. Rev. san. mil, Madr, 1934, 24: 193-203.—Fledelius, M. [Traumatic hemianopsia] Hospitalstidende, 1933, 76: neur. selsk. forh, 34-6. Also Arch, opht. Par, ,1934, 51: 561-81.—Garcia del Mazo, J. Hemianopsia por metrorragla en parto premature Actas Congr. espan. obst. gin. pediat, 1911, 2. Congr, 337-9.— Hoff. H, & Potzl, O. Ueber ein diagonal orientiertes hemiano- pisches Skotom bei vascularer Lasion der cerebralen Sehsphare. Zschr. ges. Neur. Psychiat, 1935, 152: 422-32—Pallares, J. Un cas d'hemianopsie double avec conservation de la vision maculaire, aprds la naissance. Ann. ocul. Par, 1931, 168: 45_7. ------ Un caso de hemianopsia doble neonatorum con conservaci6n de la visi6n ocular. Arch. oft. hisp. amer, 1931, 31:354-8.—Roger & Reboul-Lachaux. Deux cas d'hemianopsie traumatique: hemianopsie post-traumatique par balle, asso- ciee k un syndrome sensitif cortical parietal avec epilepsie; hemianopsie post-traumatique avec syndrome adiposo-genital. Rev. otoneur. Par, 1926, 4: 684-8.—Rollet, Langeron & Colrat. Troubles visuels post-hemorragiques du type hemi- anopsique chez un cancereux. Ibid, 1925, 3: 652-5.—Schaaff, E, & Reys, L. Hemianopsie congenitale. Ibid, 1927, 5: 659- 62 —Terrien, F. Hemianopsie double et cecite corticale. Progr. med. Par, 1938, 575-80. --- homonym. Gaillard, C. *Les hemianopsies laterales homonymes dans Ie3 tumeurs c6rebrales. 119p. 8? Lyon, 1934. Adrogue, E. Consideraciones sobre las hemianopsias hom6nimas. Arch. oft. B. Aires, 1939, 14: 584-647.—Allen, T. D, & Carman, H. F, jr. Homonymous hemianopic para- central scotoma; report of a case. Arch. Ophth, Chic, 1938, 20: 846-9.—Barkan, O, & Boyle, S. F. Paracentral homony- mous hemianopic scotoma. Ibid, 1935, 14: 957-9.—Barletta, V. Sopra due casi di emianopsia omonima e di anopsia omonima in quadranti di origine corticale. Ann. ottalm, 1930, 58: 353- 61.—Bender, M. B., & Kanzer, M. G. Dynamics of homony- mous hemianopias and preservation of central vision. Brain, Lond, 1939, 62: 404—21.—Borsotti, I. Considerazioni su un caso di emianopsia laterale omonima in seguito ad alcoolteza- zione del ganglio di Gasser; con alcune osservazioni sperimentali. Riv. otoneur, 1938, 15: 408-27.—Bourdier, F., & Trotot, R. Un cas d'hemianopsie homonyme avec troubles chromatique des 2 champs visuels posant le probleme d'un agnosie chromati- que. Bull. Soc. opht. Paris, 1937, 12-8.—Bourguet, J. Hemi- anopsie laterale homonyme gauche par blessure parietale; perte de substance de la dure-mere avec hernie cerebrate; trepanation et greffe de fascia lata. Bull. Soc. chir. Paris, 1934, 26: 657.— Bucy, P. C, & Case, T. J. An association between homonymous hemianopsia and unilateral absence of the alpha waves. Tr. Am. Neur. Ass, 1940, 66: 17-20.—Bunge, E. Ueber homonyme Hemianopsie. Abh. Augenh, 1928, H. 8, 1-51, pl.—Case, T. J. Association of homonymous hemianopia and unilateral absence of alpha waves. Arch. Neur. Psychiat, Chic, 1940, 43: 1273.—Dejean, C. Hemianopsie homonyme chez un hemi- piegique avec integrite de la vision maculaire; presentation de malade. Arch. Soc. sc. med. biol. MontpelUer, 1938, 19: 198- 202.—Demetriad.s, J. Un cats d'hemianopsie homonyme avec diagnostic du sifige de la lesion. Bull. Ophth. Soc. Egypt, 1932, 25: 150-4, pl.—Di Marzio. Scotome scintillant et hemianopsie homonyme. Rev. otoneur. Par, 1928, 6: 643-6.—Farid, N. A case of right homonymous hemianopsia. Brit. J. Ophth, 1929, 13: 67.—Gammage, F. V. Right homony- mous hemianopsia. Eye Ear &c. Month, 1941-42, 20: 137.— Hadden, S. B. A case of isolated homonymous hemianopia. Arch. Neur. Psychiat, Chic, 1937, 38: 1123.—Hoff, H, & Potzl, O. Ueber eine Zeitrafferwirkung bei homonymer links- seitiger Hemianopsie. Zschr. ges. Neur. Psychiat, 1934, 151: 599-641.—Hymes, C. Homonymous hemianopsia with and without sparing of the macula in lesions of the visual cortex. J. Lancet, 1938, 58: 20-3.—Johnson, M. H. Homonymous hemianopia: some practical points in its interpretation, with a report of 49 cases in which the lesion in the brain was verified. Tr. Am. Ophth. Soc, 1935, 33: 90-113. Also Arch. Ophth, Chic, 1936, 15: 604-16.—Lillie, W. I. Homonymous hemi- anopia; the primary sign of tumors involving the lateral part of the transverse fissure. Proc. Mayo Clin, 1929, 4: 257. Also Am. J. Ophth, 1930, 3. ser, 13: 13-20.—Marmoiton & Bar- berousse. Un cas d'hemianopsie homonyme traumatique datant de 18 ans. Bull. Soc. opht. Paris, 1925, 608-12 — Meyer, G. Transmission hereditaire factice d'une hemianopsie homonyme. Arch, opht. Par, 1939, n. ser, 3: 597. Also Schweiz. med. Wschr, 1939, 69: 18.—Monbrun. Les hemi- anopsies laterales homonymes d'origine vasculaire. Paris med, 1937, 105: 160-3.—Morax, V. Regression d'une hemianopsie homonyme droite par compression du lobe occipital gauche apres exerese de la tumeur. Ann. ocul. Par, 1926, 163: 589- 96. Also Bull. Soc. opht. Paris, 1926, 197.—Nutt, A. B. Ho- mo?XmSus hemianopia associated with arterio-sclerosis. Tr. Ophth. Soc. U. K, 1930, 50: 637—Petragnani, V. Emianopsia omonima sinistra da calcificazione della carotide interna. Riv. otoneur, 1931, 8: 317-23, pl.—Pomme, B., Guillaume, J, & Hamon, J. Menmgiome parasagittal droit et hemianopsie laterale homonyme droite. Rev. otoneur. Par, 1938, 16: 383-7.—Reboul-Lachaux, J. Hemianopsie laterale homonyme gauche permanente et spasmes vasculaires k expression hemi- anopsique droite paroxystique avec conservation de la vision centrale; crises visuelles en longue-vue. Ibid, 1928, 6: 639- 41-—Repetto, R. L, & Courtis, B. Sobre un caso de hemianopsia homonima derecha con trastornos del lenguaje. Rev. As. med- argent, 1935, 49: 829-33.—Saucier, J. Hemianopsie laterale homonyme et petit mal consecutifs k un traumatisme cranien. Union med. Canada, 1937, 66: 949-52.—Schiff-Wertheimer, S. Hemianopsies homonymes au cours de la grossesse. Bull. Soc. opht. Paris, 1927, 147-50.—Sjogren, V. H. De la valeur diagnostique de l'integrite maculaire dans l'hemianopsie homonyme. Acta psychiat. neur, Kbh, 1928, 3: 233-63.— Soriano, F. J. Semiologia de las hemianopsias homonimas. Sem. med, B. Air, 1931, 38: 1005-37.—Terrien, F., Veil, P, & Voisin, J. Hemianopsie homonyme double avec diminution de l'acuite visuelle maculaire et conservation de la vision coloree chez un aphake. Rev. otoneur. Par, 1938, 16: 140.—Veil, P. L'hemianopsie laterale homonyme; ce qu'elle signifie; sa recherche; ses causes. Rev. gin. clin. ther, 1928, 42: 742-4.— Villard, H, & Dejean, C. Ramollissement de la region cal- carine dans un cas d'hemianopsie homonyme. Arch. Soc. sc. med. biol. Montpellier, 1932, 13: 287-90.—Vogt, C, & Halbron, P. Alteration de la region hypophysaire; hemianopsie laterale homonyme. Rev. otoneur. Par, 1936, 14: 106-9.—Weill, G, & Nordmann, J. Le calibre de la pupille dans l'hemianopsie homonyme. Ibid, 1933, 11: 20-2. ---- horizontal. Aubaret. Hemianopsie inferieure par embolie et angio- spasmes retiniens. Rev. otoneur.. Par, 1931, 9: 507-9.— Cartel le, J, & Subriana, A. Hemianopsia horizontal inferior por herida de guerra. Rev. espan. med. cir. guerra, 1940, 4: 35-46.—Casagrandi, G. Sopra un caso di emianopsia oriz- zontale inferiore traumatica. Lettura oft, 1927, 4: 318-20.— Froge. Hemianopsie horizontale superieure et chorio-retinite d'aspect lineaire. Bull. Soc. opht. Paris, 1927, 60-7.—Noble, T. P. A case of bilateral superior hemianopsia. Tr. Far East. Ass. Trop. M, 1930, 1: 538-41, 2 pl.—Terrien & Dollfus, M. A. Un cas d'hemianopsie horizontale inferieure chez un malade syphilitique. Rev. otoneur. Par, 1926, 4: 382-5. ------ & Velter. Hemianopsie horizontale inferieure non traumatique. Bull. Soc. opht. Paris, 1926, 237-42.—Velter & Willemin. Un cas d'hemianopsie horizontale inferieure par lesion chiasma- tique probable. Rev. neur. Par, 1926, 33: 633-5. ---- monocular. Lehmann, H. Ein Fall von ungewohnlicher einseitiger Hemianopsia inferior. Zschr. Augenh, 1926, 59: 145-55.— Lutz, A. La hemianopsia uniocularis de origen central. Cron. med. quir. Habana, 1927, 53: 357-84.—Quensel, F. Ein Fall von rechtsseitiger Hemianopsie mit Alexie und zentral beding- tem monokularem Doppeltsehen. Mschr. Psycniat, 1927. 65: 173-207.—Rakonilz, J. [Two cases of monocular hemianopsia from prechiasmatic lesion] Orvoskepzes, 1934, 24: 986-8. ---- Pathology. Agnello, F. Sopra un caso d'emianopsia doppia con perdita della visione maculare. Arch, ottalm, 1935, 42: 39-56.— Bencini, A. Reperto anatomo-patologico in un caso di doppia emianopsia con conservazione del campo visivo maculare: contributo alio studio delle vie visive cerebrali. Riv. neur. Nap, 1928, 1: 353-76, pl.—Brown, E. V. L, & Kronfeld, P. C. The acuity of binocular depth perception in hemianopsia. Tr Am. Ophth. Soc, 1930, 28: 231-49. Also Arch. Ophth, Chic, 1930, n. ser, 4: 626-39. Also repr.—Fuchs, W. Unter- suchungen uber das Sehen der Hemianopiker und Hemi- amblyopiker. Zschr. Psychol. Physiol. Sinnesorg, 1. Abt, 1920 84- 67-169. ------ Eine Pseudofovea bei Hemianopi- kern! Psychol. Forsch, 1922, 1: 157-86.—Gelb, A, & Gold- stein, K. Psychologische Analysen hirnpathologischer Falle; zur Frage nach der gegenseitigen funktionellen Beziehung der geschadigten und der ungeschadigten Sehsphare bei Hemi- anopsie (Mikropsie infolge der Vorherrschaft der Vorgange in der geschadigten Sehsphare) Ibid, 1925, 6: 187-99— Hilgard, E. R, & Wendt, G. R. The problem of reflex sensitivity to light studied in a case of hemianopsia. Yale J. Biol, 1933, 5: 373- g5 pl.—Michon, P, Gault, A, & Salmon. Hemianopsie et syndrome hemiataxoparetique; reactivation therapeutique; guerison. Bull. Soc. opht. Paris, 1936, 286-92.—Pesme, P. Scotome hemianopsique maculaire avec hemiachromatopsie. Rev. otoneur. Par, 1931, 9: 13-5.—Pfeifer, R. A. Hirn- pathologischer Befund in einem Fall von doppelseitiger Hemi- anopsie mit Maculaaussparung. J. Psychol. Neur, Lpz, 1929r 30 40- 319-37 4 pl.—Riese, W. Das Gefiissgebiet der Hemi- anopsie. Klin. Wschr, 1927, 6: 351-3.—Uhthoff, W. Ueber Hemianopsie und Flimmerskotom. Klin. Mbl. Augenh, 1927, 78- 305-15—Velhagen, K, jr. Ueber indirekte heteronyme Hemianopsien. Ibid, 1938, 101: 801-18—Weekers, L, & Hubin R. Hemianopsie double avec integrite de la vision centrale. Bo'!. Soc. beige opht, 1933, No. 66, 46-59. ------ HEMIANOPSIA 492 HEMIATROPHY Hemianopsie double avec integrite de la vision centrale; la projection corticale de la retine. Liege med, 1933, 26: 1285- 306.— Wilbrand, H. Ueber die makulare Aussparung. Zschr. Augenh, 1925-26, 58: 261-8. ---- pregnancy and menstrual. Fischer, F. Ueber die Ursachen bitemporaler Hemianopsie bei Schwangerschaft. Zschr. Augenh, 1934-35, 85 88-108.— Hagedoorn, A. Temporale Hemianopsie wahrend der Schwan- gerschaft. Klin. Mbl. Augenh, 1935, 94: 388. Also Ned. tschr. geneesk, 1935, 79: 1992-4.—Jean-Sedan. Hemianopsie transitoire, recidivante, avcaractSre menstruel, par angiospasmes a la fois corticaux et retiniens chez une arteritique syphilitique hypertendue. Rev. otoneur. Par, 1937, 15: 591-9.—Shimkin, N. Contribution k l'etude de l'hemianopsie bitemporale gravidique. Fol. ophth. orient, 1932-33, 1: 90-103.—Young, C. A. Homonymous hemianopsia during pregnancy aided by reflecting prism. Arch. Ophth, Chic, 1929, n. ser, 2: 560-5. Also repr ---- Psychological aspect. See also Hallucination, visual; Orientation. Kalus, F. R. *Ein Fall von HaUuzinationen im hemianopischen Gesichtsfeld [Berlin] 31p. 8? Charlottenb., 1937. Engerth, G, & Hoff, H. Ein Fall von HaUuzinationen im hemianopischen Gesichtsfeld; Beitrag zur Genese der optischen HaUuzinationen. Mschr. Psychiat. Neur, 1929-30, 74: 246- 56. ------ & Potzl, O. Zur Patho-Physiologie der hemiano- pischen HaUuzinationen. Zschr. ges. Neur. Psychiat, 1935, 152: 399-421.—Gronberg, A. Contribution k l'etude des hallucinations de la vue dans l'hemianopsie. Acta med. scand, 1925-26, 63: 355-68.—Hauptmann, A. Antwort auf die Arbeit von Hoff: zur Frage der formalen Gestaltung optischer HaUuzinationen im hemianopischen Gesichtsfeld. Zschr. ges. Neur. Psychiat, 1932, 139: 158-60.—Kanzer, M, & Bender, M. B. Spatial disorientation with homonvmous defects of the visual field. Arch. Ophth, Chic, 1939, 21: 439-46.—Longhi, L. La deviazione della marcia negli emianopsici. Riv. sper. freniat, 1939, 63: 5-37.—Sobol, M. [Case of homonymous hemianopsia and optic hallucination] Vrach. delo, 1928, 11: 209-12. ---- Quadrantanopsia. Balado, M, Adrogue, E, & Franke, E. Contribuci6n al estudio anat6mico de las hemianopsias en cuadrante. Bol. Inst. clin. quir, B. Air, 1928, 4: 520-35, pl.—Bollack, J, Haguenau, J, & Voisin, J. Hemianopsie en quadrant chez un acromegaloid syphilitique. Rev. otoneur. Par, 1939, 17: 383-6.—Euzidre, J, Viallefont, H. [et al.] Hemianopsie en quadrant avec eclat d'obus juxta-cranien, mise en evidence 16 ans apres la blessure. Arch. Soc. sc. med. biol. Montpellier, 1933, 14: 40-3.—Faure- Beaulieu & Joseph, E. A propos de 2 cas de scotomes hemi- anopsiques homonyme,? en quadrants. Rev. otoneur. Par, 1938, 16: 171-5.—Felix, ('. H. Crossed quadrant hemianopsia. Brit. J. Ophth., 1926, 10: 191-5.—Gourfein-Welt & Redaille. Hemianopsie en quadrant superieur; etude anatomique et clinique. Rev. gen. opht, Geneve, 1921, 35: 340-6.—Roger, H, Poursines, Y., & Audier, M. Hemianopsie horizontale inferieure par blessure de guerre des lobes occipitaux; parkin- sonisme tardif post-traumatique. Rev. otoneur. Par, 1934, 12: 214-9.—Villard, H., & Dejean, C. Hemianopsie homonyme en quadrant irregulier; recherches pathogeniques. Arch. Soc sc. med. biol. Montpellier, 1933, 14: 61-9.—Worms, G. Hemi- anopsie en quadrant, sequelle d'hemorragie meningee. Rev otoneur. Par., 1930, 8: 480-3. ---- Treatment. Colapinto, G. Emianopsia omonima guarita con iniezioni di acetilcolina. Ann. ottalm, 1931, 59: 883.—Hambresin. Hemianopsie bitemporale typique compietement disparue k la suite d'application de rayons X; quelques reflexions sur les resultats de la radiotherapie dans les cas de tumeur hypophy- saire. Bull. Soc. beige opht, 1930, 74-81.—Jaeckel, C. E. Optical correction of a case of homonymous hemianopsia Tr Am. Acad. Optometry, 1933, 8: 17-25.—Metzger, E. Unter- suchungen uber die Wirkungsweise der Hemianopsie-Brillen Arch. Ophth, Berl, 1927, 118: 487-99.—Roche, C. Conseils k donner aux malades atteints d'hemianopsie. Monde med 1926, 36: 684.—Sachs, M. Ueber die Mittel zur Linderung der bei Hemianopie auftretenden Lesestdrungen. Wien med \\schr 1930, 70: 1445. ------ Come si possono alleviare i disturbi di lettura, che si osservano nella emianopia Boll ocul. Fir, 1931, 10: 339.—Wiener, A. A preliminary report regarding a device to be used in lateral homonymous hemianoD- sia. Arch. Ophth, N. Y, 1926, 55: 362, pl. HEMIATROPHY. See also Atrophy; Scleroderma; also names of parts or regions affected as Face, Hemiatrophy Kipp, P. *Em Fall von Hemiatrophia corporis sinistra (ausgenommen Kopf) mit skleroderma- tischen Veranderungen. 26p. 8? Heidelb. 1916. Adler, E. Ein Fall von halbeeitiger progressiver Muskel- dystrophie. Med. Klin, Berl, 1922, 18: 1343 — Baumann. C. [Hemihyperhydrosis, hemiatrophy and other unilateral affec- tions] Geneesk. bl, 1935, 33: 33-62.- Brack, W. IVI.cr einen Fall von hauptsiichlich halbscitig angeordneter Atrophic der Haut und der Muskeln und seine tnerapeutische Reeinnus- sune durch Cholin (Pac) Schweiz. med. Wschr, 1929, 59: 1221 —Brinton, D. Hemiatrophy and hemihypertrophy In Brit. Encycl. M. Pi act. (Rolleston, H.) Lond, 1937, 6: 416-25.—Eastwood, S. R. Right hemiatrophy. Proc. R Soc. M, Lond, 1926-27. 20: sect. stud. dis. child, 23.— Finesliver, B, & Rosow, H. M. Total hemiatrophy. J. Am M. Ass, 1938, 110: 366-8.—Kraus, W. M, & Perkins, O. c! A syndrome of the cerebral origins of the visceral nervoua system; the question of somatic and visceral atrophy and a review of the reported cases of unilateral atrophy. Arch Neur. Psychiat, Chic, 1927. 18: 249-62—Leri, A, & Arnaudet! Syndrome d'atropine complexe et disseminee: atrophie muscu- laire et atrophie cutanee, inegu'ii'res et predominantes k droite; atrophie glandulaire, atrophie oculo-motrice, atrophie optiqua k droite. Bull. Soc. med. hop. Paris, 1930, 3. ser, 46: 1290-3.— Miskolczy, D, & Dancz, M. Hemiatrophie mit Hemiparkin- sonismus. Deut. Zschr. Nervenh, 1932, 127: 194.—Pitha, V. M. Hemidystrophie musculaire avec sclerodermic. Rev neur. Par, 1937, 68: 446-9.—Pol lak, F. Ein eigenartiger Fali von einseitiger Hemiatrophie und seine Beziehungen zum vewtativen Nervensystem. Arch. Derm. Syph, Berl, 1929- 30, 159: 188-93.— Ratner, J. Ueber einen Fall von Hemi- atrophia cruciata progressiva. Deut. Zschr. Nervenh, 1927, 97: 304-10.—Svedenius, G. A case of hemiatrophy. Acta paediat, Upps, 1932-33, 14: 192-7.—Tobias, N. Congenital hemiatrophy associated with linear nevus; report of a case. Arch. Pediat, N. Y, 1928, 45: 673-80. HEMIBALLISM. See Chorea, unilateral. HEMICRANIA. See Headache; Migraine. HEMICRANIOSIS. See under Cranium, Abnormities. HEMIDESMUS. See also Sarsaparilla. Dutt, A. T, Ghosh, E. [et al.] Chemische Untersuchung der Wurzeln von Hemidesmus indicus. Arch. Pharm, Berl, 1938, 276: 333; 343. HEMIHYPERTROPHY. See Gigantism, partial. HEMIMELUS. See also Extremity, Abnormity; Limb, Ab- normity. Grimatjp, J. B. R. *Variations famihales associees (hemimeiie cubitale partielle, exostoses osteogeniques, syndactylie) 48p. 8? Par., 1926. Abadie & Gagniere. Hemimeiie portant sur la tige cubitale. Bull. anat. Paris, 1903, 78: 436-9.—Abrassart. Deux cas de nodosites juxta-articulaires et un cas d'hemimeiie observes au Congo beige. Rev. med. hyg. trop. Par, 1913, 10: 129-33 — Aburel. Un cas d'hemimeiie. Bull. Soc. obst. gyn. Paris, 1928, 17: 826-9.—Caratozzolo, A. Un caso raro di emimelia. Arch. ortop, Milano, 1937, 18: 435-9.—Chiariello, A. Contribution a 1 etude de 1'hemimeiie; absence de la main. Rev. orthop. Par 1928, 3. ser.. 15: 242-51.—Costa, A, & Correia, M. Un cas d hemimeiie du membre superieur droit. Fol. anat. Univ. Conimbr, 1931, 6: No. 4, 1-3.—De Vriese, B. Etude anatomi- que d'un monstre hemimeie; interpretation morphologique. Ann. Soc. med. Gand, 1907, 87: 208-16, pl.—Evrard, H. Dissection d'un chien hemimeie. Ann. anat. path. Par, 1935, 12: 219-22.—Faix. Musculature du membre malform6 chez un hemimeie. Bull. Soc. obst. Paris, 1906, 9: 88-93.—Feil, A, & Bachman. Considerations sur 1'hemimeiie et sa pathogenie; a propos d'un nouveau cas. Sem. hop. Paris, 1928, 4: 546-9.— Fischer, H. Fall von Hemimeiie. N. York. med. Mschr, 1904, 16: 526.—Fontes, V. Nota sobre um caso de hemimelia. Arq. anat, Lisb, 1929-30, 13: 191-209. ------ O hemimeiico pintor sem maos. Ibid, 523-50.—Jubleau, G. A propos d'un Vfa d hemimeiie (XXXI, 87) Chron. med. Par, 1926, 33: 7 ■'—K,'PPel> M-» & Bouchet, P. Hemimeiie avec atrophie ™enque des tissus; etude anatomique et pathogenique de 1 hemimeiie. N. iconogr. Salpetriere, Par, 1907, 20: 290; 334; 396; 3 pl.—Klippel, M., & Rabaud, E. Hemimeiie thoracique droite. Rev. Ecole anthrop. Paris, 1906, 16: 141-51.—May- gner & Haller. Monstre hemimeie; malformation de la bouche. Bull. Soc. obst. Paris, 1910, 13: 154-6.—Olivera Baez, C. E. Hemimelia transversa pura. Rev. med, B. Air, 1940, 2: 151- 3- Patel & Charton. Hemimeiie des 4 membres. Lyon HEMIMELUS 49$ HEMIPLEGIA chir, 1935, 32: 96-8. Faits cliniques; un cas d'aplasie des 4 membres, hemimeiie. Rev. orthop. Par, 1938, 3 ser, 25: 331-8.—Regnault, F. L'hemimeiie partielle. Progr. med. Par, 1909, 3. ser, 25: 305.—Salmon, J. Descrip- tion anatomo-histologique d'un hemimeie. C. rend. Soc. biol, 1907, 62: 341.—Schebat, L. Hemimeiie uni-laterale droit et agenesie cutanee peri-ombilicale. Bull. Soc. obst. gyn. Paris, 1937, 26: 485.—Scherrer, T., & Latour. Hemimeiie des membres superieurs avec mains botes et ectrodactylie chez un mort-ne de 8)4 mois. Echo med. nord, 1910, 14: 269-71.— Silverman, S. A case of hemimelus. J. Obst. Gyn. Brit. Empire, 1932, 39: 591, 2 pl.—Strouzer, W. Aplasies congeni- tales multiples; hemimeiies transverses symetriques des extremites; edentation. J. radiol. electr, 1939, 13: 169.— Variot, G. Hemimeiie des membres superieurs etphocomeiic des membres inferieurs. Bull. Soc. anthrop. Paris, 1910, 230-3. HEMIN. See under Hematin. HEMIPARESIS. See Hemiplegia. HEMIPLEGIA. See also Cerebral nerves, Paralysis; Extremity, Paralysis; Paralysis; Pyramidal tract; also in 3. ser. Paralysis, unilateral. Cacciapuoti, G. B. II cammino laterale nelle emiplegie; studio clinicografico. Ann. neur. Nap, 1909, 27: 71-84.— Cautley, E. Hemiplegia of sudden onset. Proc. R. Soc. M, Lond, 1926-27, 20: Sect. Stud. Dis. Child, 7.—Coulter, F. E. Hemiplegia: acute onset. Med. Herald, 1910, 29: 292-7.— Feiling, A. Hemiplegia. Practitioner, Lond, 1934, 133: 62- 75.—Jones, D. W. C. Observations on hemiplegia. Med. J. Australia, 1936, 2: 583-90.—Justman, S. [Hemiplegic syn- drome; pathogenesis, treatment, prognosis] Warsz. czas. lek, 1938, 15: 41; 61.—Mally. Les hemipiegies. Centre med. pharm, Gannat, 1907-8, 13: 258; 302.—Perisson, J. Etude clinique des hemipiegies organiques de l'adulte. Gaz. hop, 100: 245; 285; 317.—Pritchard, E. A. B. Hemiplegia. In Brit. Encycl. M. Pract. (Rolleston, H.) Lond, 1937, 6: 426-41 — Rosenboim, A. [Material on hemiplegia] Sovrem. psikhonevr, 1929, 8: 260-7. ---- Associated diseases. Aynsley, T. R. Hemiplegia associated with extensive naevus and mental defect. Brit. J. Child. Dis, 1928, 25: 197- 200.—Babonneix, L, & Berteaux. Association chez une meme malade d'une hemipiegie infantile ancienne et de symp- tomes recents de tumeur cerebrale. Ann. med. chir. inf., Par, 1907, 11: 145-50.—Brushfield, T, & Wyatt, W. Hemiplegia associated with extensive naevus and mental defect. Brit. J. Child. Dis, 1927, 24: 98-106.—Da Silva Amado, J. J. Um caso notavel de hemiplegia espasmodica infantil e idiotismo; atrophia muito pronunciada do hemispheric cerebral opposto ao lado paralysado. Med. contemp., Lisb, 1911, 29: 89.— Mikhnevich, I. [Cerebral hemiplegia combined with multiple neuritis] Med. obozr, Moskva, 1911, 76: 601-8.—Oliveira, O. de. Sobre um caso de associacSo de phenomenos de hemiplegia organica aos da serie tabida. Brasil med, 1919, 33: 366.— Raymond. Nevrites traumatiques et hemipiegie cerebrale associees. Rev. gen. clin. ther, 1910, 24: 278.—Regnier, D. Hernie etrangiee dans un uterus inverse chez une hemipiegique. Bordeaux chir, 1938, 9: 213.—Spriggs, E. I, & Higgs, F. W. A case of hemiplegia occurring in an epileptic at 4 years of age, with athetosis of the arm. Rep. Soc. Study Dis. Child, Lond, 1906-7, 7: 33.—Stewart, R. M. A case of infantile hemiplegia associated with facial naevus and mental defect. J. Neur. Psychopath, Lond, 1931, 12: 47-52.—Sundaram, S. K. A case of schistosomiasis with hemiplegia. Madras M.J, 1937, 17: 321.—Van Eman, F. T. A case of gall-stones complicating paresis. Kansas City M. Index Lancet, 1908, 29: 47-9.— Younge, W. A, & Mcintosh, E. F, jr. Case report; sickle cell anemia with hemiplegia. J. Nat. M. Ass, N. Y, 1941, 33: 130. ---- bilateral. See Diplegia; Paraplegia. ---- Bulbar syndromes. See also Amyotrophic lateral sclerosis, and names of other systemic bulbar affections; also Paralysis, bulbar, &c. Simonin, M. *De l'h^miplegie palatolaryngee; essai de pronostic. 8? Par., 1909. Collet, M. Un nouveau type d'hemipiegie laryngee associee (hemipiegie glosso-laryngo-scapulo-pharyngee) Ann. mal. oreille, 1914, 40: 740-8.—Deak, I. Acut (apoplexies) bulbaris paralysis esete keresztezett heminaesthesi&val. Gy6gy£szat, 1912, 52: 223.—Garcia Tapia. Una observaci6n mds de hemi- pardlisis de la laringe y de la lengua sin paralisis del velo. Rev. clin. Madrid, 1910, 3: 451.-Hirsch, E. Dissoziierte Empfindungsstorung in der linken Kniegelenkzone, als Folce wirkung ernes rechtsseitigen bulbaren Herdes. Mschr Povnbint 1927 64: 299-318-Kaufmann. Apoplektiformer Buibfa! paralyse, Augenmuskellahmungen undgekreuzterExtremitaten. lahmung. Vereinsbl. pfalz. Aerzte, 1926, 38: 9 — Kolnin O Erweichungsherde in der Medulla oblongata mit retrograded Degenerationen in Pyramidenbahn und Schleife Ar^h Psychiat, Berl, 1906, 41: 286-94, pl.—Marchal, G ' & Lere boullet, J. Un cas de syndrome lateral du bulbe Bull Soc med. hop. Paris, 1935 3. ser, 51: 1178-81.—Mevlu'd Dogantuc' [Case of alternate hemiplegia of the bulbar tvoel Askpri sihhiye mecmuasi, 1941, 70: 32-5.—Muls, G. Hemipiegie alterne d'origine bulbaire chez un enfant. Clinique Brux 1907, 21: 40L-3.—Pafiski [Paralysis glossopharyngolabialis apoplectica] Czasopismo lek, L6dz, 1908, 10: 70.—Paul W E. Notes from the neurological department of the Massa- chusetts General Hospital; sudden (apoplectiform) buibar paralysis; hemiplegia; astereognosis. Boston M. & S J 1904 144: 253.—Popper, E. [Akute rechtsseitige Bulbarlahmung und Ataxie] Mitt. Ges. inn. Med. Kinderh. Wien 1908 7- 184-6.—Roger, H, Farnarier, F. [et al.] Syndrome 'de paresie unilaterale des nerfs moteurs oculaires droits et de paralysie bilaterale des derniers nerfs craniens k marche lente; poliobul- bite subaigue. Rev. otoneur. Par, 1939, 17: 390-2.—Rose F, & Lemaitre, F. De l'hemipiegie palatolaryngee. Ann' mal. oreille, 1907, 33: pt2, 467-526.—ViiIaret, M, &Haguenau! J. Un nouveau cas de syndrome de Tapia. Rev neur Par ' 1935, 42: pt 2, 981-4. " ' ---- Bulbar syndromes: Avellis, Bonnier, Cestan-Chenais, Jackson, &c. Boehm, A. *Ein Fall von Wallenberg'schem Syndrom (nebst dem Versuch einer pathogeneti- schen Deutung des Syndroms sowie einer Zusam- menstellung und Auswertung der hauptsach- lichsten einschlagigen Literatur) [Greifswald] 57p. 22>^cm. Bottrop, 1937. Babonneix, L, Halphen & Wilm. Syndrome d'Avellis Bull. Soc. pediat. Paris, 1933, 31: 82-4.—Benestad, G. [Two cases with Wallenberg's syndrome] Norsk, mag. laegevid, 1933, 94: 523-7.—Bloch, A. Presentation d'un enfant atteint d'hemipiegie veio-palatine. Ann. otolar. Par, 1935, 686.— Cestan, R, & Sorel, R. Un nouveau cas avec autopsie de syndrome de Cestan et Chenais. Encephale, 1932, 27: 35-41.— Chavany, J. A. Contribution k l'etude des syndromes bulbaires en foyer; k propos d'un cas clinique de syndrome d'Avellis avec hemianesthesie croisee. Paris med, 1933, 87: 511-6.— Gilardini, G. Sopra un caso di sindrome di Avellis associata. Osp. maggiore, Milano, 1911, 6: 3-11.—Laignel-Lavastine & Cauzard, P. Ramollissement de l'hemibulbe droit par thrombo- arterite syphilitique: syndromes de Jackson et sympathique oculaire. Bull. Soc. med. h6p. Paris, 1904, 3. ser, 21: 770-80.— Lenoble & Pineau. Syndrome d'Avellis d'origine obscure spontanement gueri. Ibid, 1927, 3. ser, 51: 395-8.—Mari- nesco, G, & Draganesco, S. Syndrome bulbaire k predominance interolivaire; alterations vasculaires progressives; hypoplasie et nevromes bulbo-medullaires. Encephale, 1926, 21: 89-98, 3 pl.—Mattirolo, G. I sintomi oculari e labirintici nella sin- drome bulbare retro-olivare. Riv. otoneur, 1934, 11: 248-51.— Moulonguet. Discussion du syndrome de Bonnier. Rev. otoneur. Par, 1928, 6: 205-14.—Pagano, A. Emiplegia velo- faringolaringea sinistra d'origine bulbare. Otorinolar. ital, 1936, 7: 199-208.—Pa^asse, Gaillard & Magnard. Syndrome de la calotte bulbaire retro-olivaire. Lyon med, 1932, 150: 329.—Roger, H, Simeon & Coulange. Syndrome de Cestan- Chenais par ramollissement bulbaire gauche; tr^s legers signes paretiques gauches et nystagmus antihoraire. Rev. otoneur. Par, 1928, 6: 182-6.—Savonuzzi, E. Sopra un caso di sin- drome di Jackson. Riforma med, 1908, 24: 1131-4.—Thiroloix, J. Forme grave du syndrome de Bonnier. J. med. int., Par, 1906, 10: 201. ---- capsular and subcortical. See also Brain, Internal capsule. Austregesilo, A. La contractura en las hemiplejfas capsu- lars. Dfa med, B. Air, 1931-32, 4: 117.—Austregesilo, filho. Hemiplegia capsular e lesoes piramido-extrapiramidais. An. assist, psicopat, Rio (1931) 1932, 189-97, pl.—Dassen, R. A proposito de la hemianestesia en las hemiplejfas capsulares. Rev. As. med. argent, 1932, 45: 1144-6. ---- Casuistics. Anderson, M' C. A case of hemiplegia with special reference to diagnosis and treatment. Tr. Med. Chir. Soc. Glasgow, 1902, 3: 125.—Barani, F. Sopra un caso di emiplegia totale. Gazz. med. lombarda, 1908, 67: 24; 29.—Brownfield, O. D. An unusual case of hemiplegia. J. R. Nav. M. Serv, 1934, 20:73.—Eagar, W. H. An unusual case of hemiplegia. Mari- time M. News, Halifax, 1907, 19: 108-10.— Engelmann. Zwei Falle von zerebraler Hemipiegie. Wien. klin. Wschr, 1912, 25: 549.—Maitland-Jones, A. An unusual example of hemi- plegia. Proc. R. Soc. M, Lond, 1937-38, 31: 760.—Mecz- kowski & Jaroszyfiski [Two cases of unilateral motor dis- turbances] Neur. polska, Warsz, 1911-12, 2: 473-5.— HEMIPLEGIA Ricard. Observation sur une hemipiegie. Observ. sc. med, 1823, 5: 15.—Siccio, A, & Garcia Austt, E. El caso Palacios. Rev. psiquiat. Uruguay, 1940, 5: No. 27, 41-58.—Stephens, T. ('. Personal observations in 2 notable cases, hemiplegia and strangulated hernia. Med. Progr, Louisv, 1910, 26: 218.— Vires. Sur un hemipiegique. Montpellier med, 1909, 29: 3HI-89.—Wedd, G. D. An obscure case of hemiplegia. J. R. Nav. M. Serv, 1936, 22: 68.—Wislocki, K. Ciekawy pod wzfilcdem rozpoznawczym przypadek povazenia prawos- tronnego wraz z memota,. Kron. lek, Warsz, 1893, 14: 77-82. ---- cerebellar. See also Ataxia; Babinski-Nageotte syndrome; Cerebellum, Disease. Alurralde, M, & Sepich, M. J. Hemiplejfa cerebelosa por hemorrdgia. Dia med, B. Air, 1934-35, 7: 613-5. Also Prensa med. argent, 1935, 22: 709-13.—Brodin & Delaporte. Syndrome protuberential; hemipiegies pyramidale et sensitive croisees; hemipiegie cerebelleuse homolaterale. Rev. neur. Par, 1929, 36: pt 2, 699.—Crouzon, O, & Christophe, J. Syndrdme pseudo-bulbaire et cerebelleux d'origine protuberan- tielle avec myoclonies rythmiques et synchrones veio-pharyngo- facio-laryngees bilaterales et myoclonies oculaires et squeiet- tiques unilaterales. Ibid, 1936, 65: 76-81.—Dimitri, V. A prop6sito de la hemiplegia cerebelosa; consideraciones sobre su probable patogenia. Arch, argent, neur, 1929, 4: 32-53, pl.— Eckerstrom, S. Paralysie hemibulbaire de forme rare et s'accompagnant de symptomes cerebelleux nettement accuses. Acta med. scand, 1934, 81:107-12.—Enriquez, R, & Gutmann. Lesion bulbo-protuberantielle avec syndrome cerebelleux. Rev. neur. Par, 1912, 24: 758. Euziere, Pages & Chardon- neau. Syndrome de Babinski-Nageotte. Bull. Soc. sc. med. biol. Montpellier, 1925-26, 7: 443-5.—Jakob, C. Hemiplejfa, hemiataxia y hemianestesia homolateral cerebelosa; comunica- ci6n resumida. Actas Conf. lat. amer. neur, 1929, 1. Conf, 240-52. Also Arch, argent, neur, 1929, 4: 13-31. ---- Cerebral nerves. See Cerebral nerves, Paralysis; also proper names of nerves as Facial nerve, Paralysis, &c. ---- Diagnosis, and prognosis. Dana, C. L. The serological tests in cerebral hemiplegia- Med. Rec, N. Y, 1913, 84: 1013. Also repr.—Harland, W. G. B, & Weisenberg, F. H. A patient with latent hemiplegia made evident by prohmced etherization. Tr. Philadelphia Pediat, Soc. (1905-6) 1907, 2: 13.—Hobhouse, N. Prognosis in hemiplegia in middle life. Lancet, Lond, 1936, 1: 327.— Juarros, C. Diagnostico topografico de la hemiplejfa. Progr. clin, Madr, 1916, 7: 224-48.—Milhit. Symptomes et diag- nostic de l'hemiplegie. Gaz. hop, 1909, 82: 1769-77.— Monro, T. K. The diagnosis of hemiplegia. Proc. Interst. Postgrad. M. Ass. N. America, 1929, 5: 132-6, portr.—Roger, J. P. Dyschondroplasie k forme hemipiegique pure. Laval med, 1937, 2:257-64, 2 pl. ---- Etiology. See also under primary diseases as Brain, Hemorrhage; Brain, Injury; Brain tumor; Gen- eral paralysis; Measles; Uremia, &c. Botjtboul, J. *Rapports des hemipiegies avec l'hypertension arterielle. 47p. 8? Par., 1935. Aubertin, C, & Lafon, J. Coma et hemipiegie curables con- secutifs k une hematemese. Bull. Soc. med. hop. Paris, 1940, 3. ser, 56: 369-71.—Auer, E. M. Cerebral hemiplegia, a sequela of diphtheria. N. York M. J, 1915, 101: 956. Also repr.—Barbier & Wenger. Hemipiegie au cours d'une anemie aigue post hemorragique. Lyon med, 1933, 151: 261-9.— Barker, L. F. Left hemiplegia following upon arteriothrom- bosis due to operation for removal of an endotheliomatous mass in the right side of the neck. Med. CUn. N. America, 1930, 14: 253-6.—Barr6, J. A. Hemipiegie par hemorragie et hemipiegie par ramollissement cerebral; signes et traitements speciaux. Medecine, Par, 1927, 8: 346-50. ------ Kabaker & Char- bonnel. Hemipiegie purement deficitaire, symptomatique d'une tumeur sous-corticale sans hypertension du L. C. R, ni stase papillaire. Rev. neur. Par, 1938, 69: 363-72.—Barre, J. A., & Woringer, E. Syndrome d'hypertension cranienne; hemiparesie; debut d'hemianopsie; non remplissage d'un ventricule lateral; evolution favorable sans intervention chirurgicale; encephalite possible. Rev. otoneur. Par, 1939 17: 351-3.—Burr, C. W, & Camp, C. D. Peripheral obliterating arteritis as a cause of triplegia following hemiplegia and paraplegia. Am. J. M. Sc, 1905, 129: 960-6. Also repr.— Cahen, J, & Dagnelie, J. Arachnoidite spinale operee et guerie chez un jeune femme atteinte d'une hemipiegie datant de l'enfance. J. neur. psychiat, Brux, 1934, 34: 333-40.— Cavaliero, G. Emiplegia per caso della gotta retrospinta da 2 anni e mezzo e guarita con frequenti afflussi articolari. Filiatre sebezio, Nap, 1841, 22: 86-90.—Chauffard, A, & Troisier, J. Hemipiegie oxycarbonee avec reaction meningee secondaire, d'origine corticale. Bull. Soc. med. h6p. Paris, 1909, 3. ser, 26: HEMIPLEGIA 1296-300.—Dobrokhotov, M. S. [Hemipiegie form of epidemic encephalitis] J. nevropat. psikhiat, Moskva, 1928, 21: 5— 1 <». — Fatal case; hemiplegia; subarachnoid hematoma. S. Thomas Hosp. Rep, Lond, 1905, n. ser, 33: 263.—Ford, F. R. Throm- bosis of the cerebral arteries with a discussion of hemiplegia Med. Clin. N. America, 1937, 21: 1523-36- Frey. Un caa d'hemipiegie consecutif A une injection sous-muciueuse d adrena- line. Ann. mal. oreille, 1907, 33: 342-7.—Keency, K. I.. Hemiplegia following injection of epinephrine hydrochloride. J. Am. M. Ass, 1939, 112: 2131— Laignel-Lavastine. Hemi- piegie ancienne par ramollissement avec anesthesie il maximum peripherique et abolition des reflexes tendineux du membre inferieur. Bull. Soc. anat. Paris, 1907, 82: 087-91.—Lesieur, C. Hemipiegie d'origine cerebrale au cours d'une fievre tvpholde Lyon med, 1908, 110: 172-6.—Merwarlh, H. R. Hemiplegia of cortical or venous origin; occlusion of rolandic veins. Brook- lyn Hosp. J, 1940, 2: 193-212. Also repr. ------& Gold, M. Hemiplegia of venous origin. Med. Times, N. Y, 1911, 69: 292 9.—Poinso, R, & Battesti, P. Hemipiegie par encephalite au ilecours d'une fifivre boutonneuse. Bull. Soc. pediat. Paris, 1939, 37: 96-104.—Ramond, L. Hemipiegie par ramollisse- ment cerebral. Presse med, 1928, 36: 859.—Roger, H, & Cremieux, A. Les hemipiegies par spoliation sanguine abnii- dante. Marseille med, 1930, 67: 117-34.—Sorensen, K. [Case of hemiplegia carotica] Hospitalstidende, 1931, 77: neur. selsk. forh, 1; 59.—Spilborghs, G. Hemiplegia no curso da insulinoterapia. Rev. gastroenter. S. Paulo, 1939, 2: 63- 77.—Valle & Aldabalde. Hemiplegia y afasia de origen dudoso. Rev. med. cir. priict, Madr, 1907, 76: 29-34.—Vedel, Vidal, J;, & Fayot. Hemipiegie uremique et retention chloree seche. Arch. Soc. sc. med. biol. Montpellier, 1928, 9: 286-9- Heisen- burg, T. H. Uremic hemiplegia with changes in the nerve cells of the brain and cord and recent primary degeneration of one central motor tract. J. Nerv. Ment. Dis, N. Y, 1904, 31: 456-64. Also repr. ---- Flaccid stage. Aring, C. D. Flaccid hemiplegia in man. Arch. Neur. Psychiat, Chic, 1940, 43: 302-17. Also repr.—Birkmayer, W. Eine Erfahrung uber induzierte Tonusveranderungen bei einem Fall von schlaffer Hemipiegie. Wien. klin. Wschr, 1938, 51: 1191.—Scheinker, I. Ueber den Entstehungsmechanismus schlaffer Lahmungen bei zerebraler Hemipiegie. Jahrb. Psychiat. Neur, 1936, 53: 63-76.—Starker, W. A. Zur Frage der schlaffen Lahmungen bei cerebralen Hemiplegien. Zschr. ges. Neur. Psychiat, 1933, 144: 418-26.—Verhaart, W. J. C. The flaccid hemiplegia of cerebral origin. Psychiat. neur. bl, Amst, 1937, 41: 211-7.—Wilheim, I. Zwei Falle von schlaffer Lahmung bei zerebraler Hemipiegie (Hangehand) Jahrb. Psychiat. Neur, 1926-27, 45: 201-7. ---- homolateral [direct] Eiselberg, A. Ueber ungekreuzte Hemipiegie nach Menin- gealblutung. In Livre d'or (T. Papayoannou) Naumburg, 1932, 112-4.—Licci, P. Sopra un caso di emiplegia omolaterale. Gazz. internaz. med, 1916, 19: 53.—Loo, C. A. van der, & de Josselin de Jong, R. Een geval van homolaterale hemipiegie. Ned. tschr. geneesk, 1912, 2: 1813.—Viner, N. A case of apparent homolateral hemiplegia. Canad. M. Ass. J, 1926, 16: 297-9. ---- infantile. See also Birth injury, Paralysis; Diplegia; Face, Hemiatrophy, &c; also under proper names of infantile paralytic affections. Keller, E. *Die Hemiplegien im Kindesalter mit besonderer Berucksichtigung von Aetiologie und Prognose unter Verwertung der Falle der Ziircher Kinderklinik aus den Jahren 1911 bis 1937 [Zurich] 71p. 22^cm. Horgen, 1938. Lacombe, M. A. J. Contribution a l'6tude etiologique de l'h6miplegie infantile. 89p. 25cm. Bord., 1934. Tola, R. *De quelques particularity d> l'hemiplegie cerdbrale infantile. 40p. 24cm. Par., 1939. Wilhelms, K. *Die operative Behandlung der infantilen cerebralen Hemipiegie. 53p. 8°. Bonn, 1911. Babonneix, L. Sur quelques cas d'hemipiegie infantile. Arch. med. enf, 1929, 32: 249-54. Also Bull. Acad, med. Par, 1929, 3. ser, 101: 344-8. Also Rev. gin. clin. ther, 1929, 43: Suppl, 690-6. Also Rev. med. Par, 1935, 52: 441-50, 5 pl.------& Duruy, A. Sur un cas d'hemipiegie infantile. Rev. neur. Par, 1926, 33: pt 2, 567-71.—Babonneix, L, & Lhermitte, J. Myopathie avec hemipiegie infantile. Ibid, 1929, 36: pt 2, 57-60.—Babonneix, Hutinel, J, & Widiez, A. Hemipiegie infantile avec obesite. Bull. Soc. pediat. Paris, 1927, 25: 263-5.—Baumann, C. [Peculiar form of unilateral central paralysis in children] Psychiat. neur. bl, Amst, 1932, 36: 419. ------ Eine besondere Form von kindlicher Lib.- HEMIPLEGIA 495 HEMIPLEGIA mung. Mschr. Psychiat, 1932-33, 84: 323-47.—Baumel & Giraud. Due casi di emiplegia nei fanciullo. Gazz. osp, 1911, 32: 323.—Benoit, E. P. Hemipiegie infantile compliquee tardi'vement d'epilepsie jacksonnienne. Gaz. mal. inf., Par, 1908 10- 129-31.—Byers, R. K. Evolution of hemiplegias in infancy Am. J. Dis. Child., 1941, 61: 915-27. Also Arch. Neur Psychiat, Chic, 1941, 45: 389-92. Also J. Nerv. Ment. Dis , 194L 93; 93-6.—Carrau, A, Mourigan, H, & Barbe- rous'se, CM. Las formats hemipl6jicas de la enfermedad de Hutinel. Arch, pediat. Uruguay, 1936, 7: 412-7.—Cordova, A de. Hemiplegia infantil; observaci6n clinica. Rev. med. cir. Habana, 1910, 15: 653, pl.—Crothers, B. Influence of age on ventricular displacement in the hemiplegias of children. Am. J. Dis. Child, 1938, 56: 710.—Edwards, W. C, & Breeden, R F. Acute infantile cerebral paralysis (hemiplegia) report of case." Wisconsin M. J, 1928, 27: 314.—D'Espine. Ancienne hemipiegie infantile de 2 malades atteints d'epilepsie post- hemipiegique. Rev. med. Suisse rom, 1912, 32: 321.—Ford, F R & Schaffer, A. J. The etiology of infantile acquired hemiplegia. Arch. Neur. Psychiat, Chic, 1927, 18: 323-47.— Gareiso, A. Hemipiegie spasmodique infantile; maladie de Heine-Medin sur le mSme sujet, due k 2 episodes independants. Rev. med. lat. amer, B. Air, 1928-29, 15: 219-24 Consideraciones sobre hemiplejia cerebral infantil. Arch. argent, pediat, B. Air, 1932, 3: 755-72— Guerin, R. Hemi- piegie infantile; traitement par neurotomies et allongement du tendon d'Achille; presentation de film. Discuss. Congr. pediat. langue fr, 1936, 9. Congr, 169-72.—Hawthorne, C. O. Infantile hemiplegia with almost complete recovery. Rep. Soc. Study Dis. Child, Lond, 1905-6, 6: 149.— Higgs, F. W, & Turner, P. Infantile hemiplegia with athetosis of arm. Ibid, 1907-8, 8: 302.—Hunter, W. K. Case of infantile hemiplegia with athetosis. Tr. Med. Chir. Soc. Glasgow, 1905-7, 6: 286-90. Also Glasgow M. J, 1907, 67: 217-21.— Ihsan Siikru Aksel [Hemiplegia in adolescents] Bull. Soc. turque med, 1941, 7: 73-6.—Jones, E. C. Atypical hemiplegia. Arch Pediat, N. Y, 1906, 23: 37-9 [Discussion] 65. Also Tr. Philadelphia Pediat. Soc. (1905-6) 1907, 2: 12.—Knapp, P. C. Hemiplegia in childhood. J. Nerv. Ment. Dis, 1887, 14: 480-502. Also repr. ------ Some post-hemiplegic dis- turbances of motion in children. Boston M. & S. J, 1888, 119: 495-500. Also repr.—Knight, G. C. Infantile hemiplegia; cerebral angioma; subarachnoid haemorrhage. Proc. R. Soc. M, Lond, 1938-39, 32: 224.—Krakora, S. [Case of abnormal development of the brain in infantile hemiplegia] Rev. neur. psychiat, Praha, 1929, 26: 308-18.—Levit, L. La hemiplejia en los j6venes. Rev. argent, neur. psiquiat, 1940, 5: 235-71.—Meyer, A. H. [Spastic paralysis of arm and leg in a 2-year old boy] Ugeskr. laeger, 1919, 81: 539.—Noica. Sur un cas d'hemipiegie infantile avec mutisme. Bull. Soc. med. h6p. Bucarest, 1926, 8: 146-51.—Nussbaum, S. Hemiplegia. Arch. Pediat, N. Y, 1932, 49: 392-8.—Obregia, A., & Urechia, C. I. Hemipiegie infantile sans degenerescence des voies pyramidales. Arch, internat. neur. Par, 1927, 20. ser, 2: 8i-5.—Sobhy Abdel Malek. A case of infantile hemiplegia and athetosis. J. Egypt. M. Ass, 1933, 16: 426.—Spota, B. B. Rigidez decerebrada meta-encefalitica con secuela de hemi- plejia infantil pir&mido-extrapiramidal derecha. Prensa med. argent, 1936, 23: 307-10.—Thomas, H. M. Hemiplegias of the first decade. Johns Hopkins Hosp. Bull, 1909, 20: 184 — Touche. Hemipiegie infantile sans athetose; atrophie de l'ecorce limitee k la moitie superieure du lobe frontal. Rev. neur. Par, 1912, 20: 223. ---- infantile, congenital. Abel, L. Congenital hemiplegia with mental deficiency, treated by dorsal and lumbar sympathectomy. Proc. R. Soc. M, Lond, 1938-39, 32: 136. Also Brit. J. Child. Dis, 1941, 38: 141.—Barnes, S. Congenital (?infantile) hemiplegia. Rep. Soc. Study Dis. Child, Lond, 1907-8, 8: 411.—Brander, T. [Manifestations in congenital spastic hemiplegia in uni- ovular twins] Nord. med, 1939, 2: 1079-83.—Dejerine, J, & Camus, P. Un cas de myoclonic congenitale chez une femme atteinte d'hemipiegie cerebrale infantile egalement congenitale. Rev. neur. Par, 1907, 15: 511.—Gaing, E, & Aguilar Giraldes, D. Hemipar&lisis abdominal congenita. Arch, argent, pediat, 1936, 7: 688-97.—Perez Valdes, R. Paralisis alterna congenita. Rev. iber. amer. cien. med, Madr, 1908, 19: 84-9— Perkins, G. A curious case of congenital spastic hemiplegia. Proc. R. Soc. M, Lond, 1923-24, 17: Sect. Orthop, 42—Silberknopf. Ein Fall von kongenitaler zerebraler Hemipiegie. Mitt. Ges. inn. Med. Kinderh. Wien, 1913, 12: 145. Also Wien. med. Wschr, 1913, 63: 1930. ---- Manifestation. Aquino, P. B. Los signos nuevos de la hemiplegia orgdnica. Sem. med, B. Air, 1912, 19: 617.—Binda, P. II segno del cordone e la deviazione dell'angolo epigastrico nell'emiplegia organica. Boll. Soc. med. chir. Pavia, 1919, 31: 487-98 — Bychowski, Z. Zur Phanomenologie der cerebralen Hemipiegie. Neur. Zbl, 1907, 26: 154-7.—Decap. Aphonie au commence- ment d'hemipiegie. Seance pub. Soc. med. Toulouse, 1821, 12.—Herman, E. [New small symptom in unilateral paresis] Neur. polska, 1937, 20: 137.—Juarros, C. Tecnica y valor prdctico de los pequenos signos de la hemiplejfa. Progr. elm, Madr, 1915, 5: 321-43.—Panski, A. [Symptoms accompany- ing hemiplegia but not entering the classic description of hemiplegia] Neur. polska, Warsz, 1913, 3: 259; 404. ---- Manifestation: Cardiovascular system. Bruch, A. H, & Buttu, G. Recherches de capillaroscopie dans les hemipiegies organiques. In Marinesco Festschr Bucar 1933 133-5.—Deutsch, F. Zur Kenntnis des funk- tionellen Verhaltens der Gefasse mit besonderer Berucksichti- gung der Hemiplegiker. Wien. klin. Wschr, 1927 40: 1124- • •-7Ma»nescu, G, Bruch, H. A, & Vasilescu, N. Die Stromung in den Blutcapillaren bei organischer Hemipiegie. Zschr. klin Med, 1934, 127: 578-89. ------ Recherches sur la perme- abilite vasculaire chez les hemipiegiques. J. beige neur psych, 1937, 37: 51-9— Paulian, D., Bistriceanu, I., & For- tunescu, C. Les asymetries de la tension arterielle et des differents reflexes neuro-vegetatifs au cours des hemipiegies Arch, neur, Bucur, 1939, 3: 68-70.—Riechert. Arterio- graphische Befunde bei atiologisch unklaren Hemiplegien. Arch. Psychiat, Berl, 1937, 107: 419.—Russetzky, J. J. Plethysmogramme bei cerebraler Hemiparese und Parkin- sonismus. Zschr. ges. Neur. Psychiat, 1927, 107: 497-506. ---- Manifestation: Locomotor system. Babinski, J. De l'abduction des doigts dans l'hemiplegie organique. Rev. neur. Par, 1907, 15: 754. ------ De la pronation de la main dans l'hemiplegie organique. Ibid, 755.—Bekhterev, V. [Finger phenomenon in organic hemi- plegias] Obozr. psikhiat. nevrol, Petrogr, 1914-15, 19: 547.— Coste, F, & Forestier, J. Hemipiegie et nodosites d'Heberden controlaterales. Bull. Soc. med. hop. Paris, 1935, 3. ser, 51: 772-6.—Forestier, J. Rhumatisme d'Heberden chez une hemipiegique, atteinte unilaterale, du cote sain. Ann. med. psychol. Par, 1935, 93: 525. Also Rev. neur. Par, 1935, 42: 442-8.—Gullotta, S. Segni piramidali della mano nella emiplegia. Riv. sper. freniat, 1933, 57: 857-79.—Herman, E. Nouveau signe dans les hemiparesies, signe de l'adduction passive du membre interieur paralyse. Encephale, 1938, 33: 132-46, pl.—Minor, L. [Hallux valgus in hemiplegia; data on combinations and on local symptoms of diathesis] J. nevropat. psikhiat, Moskva, 1911, 11: 645-70.—Pereyra Kafer, J., & Saccone, R. Artropatias precoces en un hemipiegico. Rev. As. med. argent, 1932, 45: 1201-4. Also Dia med, B. Air, 1932-33, 5: 624.—Souques, A. Sur le phenomene des interos- seux de la main ou phenomene des doigts dans l'hemiplegie organique. Bull. Soc. med. hop. Paris, 1908, 3. ser, 34: 677. ---- Manifestation, mental. De Giacomo, U. Les troubles mentaux ches lez hemipiegi- ques; considerations theoriques et recherches psychochrono- metriques. Arch, internat. neur. Par, 1936, 55: 77-82.— Duperie. Hemiparesie droite, demence organique et aphasie sensorielle. J. med. Bordeaux, 1908, 38: 297.—Ehrenwald, H. Verandertes Erleben des Korperbildes mit konsekutiver Wahnbildung bei linksseitiger Hemipiegie. Mschr. Psychiat. Neur, 1930, 75: 89-97. ------ Anosognosie und Deper- sonalisation; ein Beitrag zur Psychologie der linksseitig Hemi- plegischen. Nervenarzt, 1931, 4: 681-8.—Hoff, H, & Potzl, O. "Experimentelle Nachbildung von Anosognosie. Zschr. ges. Neur. Psychiat, 1931, 137: 722-34.—Shenderov, L. A, & Gamaleia, K. N. [Peculiar disturbance of the body scheme in hemiplegia] Nevropat. psikhiat, 1935, 4: Nos. 9-10, 361-72 — Simonini, G. Sopra un caso di emiparesi tipo organico e di stato ipomaniacale guarito dopo la pneumo-encefalografia. Note psichiat, Pesaro, 1939, 68: 547-62.—Stein, W. N. [Anosognosia and changes in the schema of the body in a case of hemiplegia caused by a cerebral tumor] Neur. polska, 1936, 19: 131-44.—Von Hagen, K. O, & Ives, E. R. Anosog- nosia (Babinski) imperception of hemiplegia; report of 6 cases, one with autopsy. Bull. Los Angeles Neur. Soc, 1937, 2: 95-103. ---- Manifestation: Movement [and posture] Graner, H. *Beitrag zur Lehre von den post-hemiplegischen Bewegungsstorungen [Tu- bingen] 23p. 4? Lpz., 1912. Poirel, M. P. *De l'hemiclonotomie post- hemiplegique; sa pathogenie; ses rapports avec les autres troubles moteurs posthemiplegiques. 238p. 8? Nancy, 1906. Bard, L. Du nystagmus artificiel chez les hemipiegiques; le nystagmus k rebours. Rev. neur. Par, 1929, 36: 179-87. De la deviation conjuguee de la tete et des yeux chez les hemipiegiques k la physiologie generale de I'appareil loco- moteur. Progr. med. Par, 1930, 273-82 ——- De la deviation conjuguee de la tete et des yeux chez les hemipiegi- nues k la physiologie generale des organes des sens. Ibid, 457-65 —Blair, D. M, & McDowall, R. J. S. On a cortical flexor tone in the fore-limb of the cat, with observations on the hemipiegie attitude in man. Brain, Lond, 1933, 56: 99- 103__Casper, J, & Pineas, H. Anatomischer Befund und Epikrise des Falles von Pineas: Eigenartige Zwangshaltung nach Hemipiegie. Zschr. ges. Neur. Psychiat, 1927, 110: 291-6 —Castro, A. de. Note sobre o andar lateral na hemi- plegia" organica. Brasil. med, 1913, 27: 390— Etienne, G. Syndrome hemi-tonoclonique post-hemipiegique; ses rapports avec les autres troubles moteurs post-hemipiegiques. Ence- phale 1907. ">: 1-12. Also Rev. med. est, 1907, 39: 215-7. HEMIPLEGIA 496 HEMIPLEGIA Also C. rend. Soc. med, Nancy. 1906-7, 47-9.—Favero, F., & Pereira, M. A cinematographia na documentaciSo de damnos ilefonuantes perceptiveis em movimento (sobre um caso de hemiplegia de origem sub-cortical) Ann. Fac. med. S. Paulo, 1935, il: 315-9, 3 pl.—Krabbe, K. H. Posthemiplegisk Tremor. Bibl. lteger, 1918, 110: 91-9.—Monro. J. K, & Faulds, A. G. Case of irregular movements of the right hand and leg in a patient of middle age, apparently referable to slight hemiplegia. Tr. Med. Chir. Soc. Glasgow, 1902, 3: 414-8.—Noica. La perte des mouvements isoies des doigts et des mouvements d'opposition du pouce, avec conservation des mouvements d'ensemble des doigts, chez des malades atteints d'hemiplcirie cerebrale legere. Rev. neur. Par, 1908, 16: 326- 8.—Kav&. G. Della deviazione oculo-cefalica detta paralitica da leMone di un emisfero cerebrale. Riv. otoneur, 1933, 10: 211-22.—Szpanbok, A. [Dynamic nervous functions in the course of motor symptoms after hcmiparesis] Gaz. lek, Warsz, 1914, 2. ser, 34: 657; 710.—Thomson, C. Hemiplegia with involuntary movements. Proc. R. Soc. M, Lond, 1907-8, 1: neur. sect, 55; 95.—Victoria, M. Hemiplejia piramidal y hemiplejia pirdmido-extrapiramidal. Arch, argent, neur, 1930, 6: 40-i. Also Sem. med, B. Air, 1930, 37: 1627-32. ' ---- Manifestation: Movement: Synkinesis. Bard, L. Les syncinesies des hemipiegiques, leurs rapports avec les associations motrices normales. Encephale, 1927, 22: 681-700. ------ Du phenomene dit d'opposition compie- mentaire chez les sujets normaux et chez les hemipiegiques; son importance en physiologie generale. Progr. med. Par, 1927, 42:1137-46. ------ Du phenomdne dit d'opposition compie- mentaire chez les sujets normaux et chez les hemipiegiques. Lyon med, 1927, 140: 439-41.—Blanchet, P. Essai de patho- genie sur les syncinesies des hemipiegies organiques cerebrates. Presse med, 1928, 36: 1209.—Clivio, C. Contratture emiple- giche o sincinesie. Riv. neur, 1929, 2: 189-98.—Klippel & Weil. De la flexion spontanee du pouce par redressement provoque des autres doigts chez les hemipiegiques contracture. J. neur. Par, 1909, 14: 217.—Kunert, G. Das Zeichen von facial.uoti. Deut. Zschr. Nervenh, 1929, 108: 146-54 — Marques, A. Al^uns pontos de vista na semiologia dos hemi- plegieos: signal de. ( aciapuoti e signal de Grasset e Gaussel. Bra-il med, 192<>, 10: pt 2, 4—6.—Noica. A propos de l'article de M. W. SlerlincSur l'adduction syncinetique du bras malade dans l'hemiplegie organique. Rev. neur. Par, 1912, 20: pt 2, 696-8.—Rouquier, A, & Blanc, P. La flexion combinee de la cuisse et du tronc; sa valeur semeiologique. Ann. med. Par, 1930, 28: 45-55.—Skoblo, M. S. Ueber eine neue Form der hemiplegischen Mitbewegungen. Deut. Zschr. Nervenh, 1928, 104: 281-5.—Sterling, W. [Synkinesis of the diseased arm in hcmiparesis; new symptom of unilateral paralysis] Med. kron. lek, Warsz, 1912, 47: 879; 901.—Stief, A, & Dancz, M. Beitrage zur Pathologie der sogenannten sym- metrischen Mitbewegungen. Deut. Zschr. Nervenh, 1933-34, 133: 206-22. ---- Manifestation: Muscles. See also Atrophy; Contracture; Muscle, De- generation. Chavany, J. A. E. Contribution k l'etude de la contracture pyramidale; essai clinique, diagnostique et pathogenique. 144p. 8? Par., 1924. Katz, J. *Die posthemiplegische Kontraktur und ihre Erklarung [Basel] 20p. 8? Butzbach. 1936. Bard, L. Des contractures post-hempiiegiques pseudo- precoces. Sem. med. Par, 1907, 27: 61-3. ------ Du mecanisme pathogenique des contractures tardives des hemi- piegiques. Presse med, 1927, 35: 769-71.—Brain, W. R. On the significance of the flexor posture of the upper limb in hemiplegia, with an account of a quadrupedal extensor reflex. Brain, Lond, 1927, 50: 113-37.—Garcin, R., Deparis, M., & Hadji-Dimo. Hemipiegie spasmodique de l'adulte avec atrophie musculaire tardive considerable; contribution k l'etude pathogenique des atrophies musculaires d'hemipiegie cerebrale de l'adulte. Rev. neur. Par, 1936, 65: 158-67.— Gonzalez, T. Atrofia muscular en la hemiplegia de los adultos; reflexiones sobre su patogenia. Sem. med, B. Air, 1918, 25: 723.—Jarkowski, J. Les troubles de la plasticite musculaire dans l'hemiplegie; epreuve de la fixation. Rev. neur. Par, 1929, 36: 468-71.—Langworthy, O. R, Highberger, E., & Foster, R. Hemiplegia with the leg in flexion. Arch. Neur. Psychiat, Chic, 1935, 34: 520-32.—Marinesco, G., Sager, O, & Kreindler, A. Variations des chronaxies musculaires a\ec l'etat de tension du muscle dans la contracture hemipiegique. C. rend. Soc. biol, 1929, 100: 622-4.—Noica. Le mecanisme de la contracture chez les spasmodiques, hemipiegiques ou parapiegiques. N. iconogr. Salpetriere, Par, 1908, 21: 25-36. ------ Sur le mecanisme de la contracture spasmodique (pyramidale) etude critique. Rev. neur. Par, 1927, 34: pt 2, 452-62.—Obarrio, J. M. La hemiplejia en flexi6n. Rev otoneur, B. Air, 1927, 1: 17-28.—Proebster. Myoelektrische Untersuchungen an Hemiplegikern, ein Beitrag zur Tonusfrage Verh. Deut. orthop. Ges. (1927) 1928, 22. Kongr., 215-23 — Russetzky, I. I. [Changes in the size of the hand used in work in cerebral hemiparcsis and parkinsonism] J. nevropat psikhiat, Moskva, 1929, 22: 180-8. Spiegel. E. Die gegen- seitigen Beziehungen zwischen Tonus, aktiver und passiver Kraft der Fingermuskeln bei Hemiplegikern. Arb. Neur. Inat Wien., 1932, 34: 91-100.—Verhaart, W. J. C. Hemiplegia with" the leg in flexion. Psychiat. neur. bl, Amst, 1936, 40: 933- 9.—Visani, C. Le contratture tardive degli emiplegici. Gior clin. med, 1932, 13: 1551-61. ---- Manifestation: Respiratory system. Dubourdieu, J, & Lamothe, E. L'ampliation respiratoire de chaque hemithorax dans l'hemiplegie cerebrale. C. rend Soc. biol. Par, 1908, 65: 156-8.—Kolb, L. C, & Klcyntjens, F. A clinical study of the respiratory movements in hemiplegia Brain, Lond, 1937, 60: 259-74.—West, S. The respiratory movements in hemiplegia: a case with tracings showing the movements of the 2 sides, and the peculiar effects of coughing, and a cyrtometer tracing showing peculiar changes in the shape of the paralysed side of the thorax. Q. J. Med, Oxf, 1907-8,1: 448-53. ---- Manifestation, sensory. See also Analgesia; Hemianesthesia; Pares- thesia. Bombi, G. La simpatectomia periarteriosa nella terapia dei dolori da emiplegia cerebrale. Policlinico, 1930, 37: sez. prat, 1204-6.—Bourguignon, G, & Dejean, R. Variations de la chronaxie vestibulaire dans l'hemiplegie avec ou sans aphasie. C. rend. Acad, sc, 1936, 203: 500-2.—D'Abundo. Emiancstesia incrociata per neoplasma del ponte di Varolio. Rass. internaz. med. mod, 1900-1,2: 121-4.—Donath, J. Sensibel-sensorische Hemipiegie mit Paralysis-agitans-artigem Tremor. Med. Klin, Berl, 1910, 6: 1814.—Dumolard, Sarrouy [et al.] Hemi- paresthesie droite de longue duree chez une malade atteinte d'hypertension arterielle permanente avec arterite cerebrale; surdievation de la tension arterielle du c6te paralyse. Rev. neur. Par, 1936, 65: 1407-10.—Gaddi. Storia di paralisi del senso al lato destro alternata. Mem. med. contemp, Venez, 1841, 5: 79-85.—Gordon, A. Painful hemiplegia: a considera- tion of central pain. Arch. Neur. Psychiat, Chic, 1937, 38: 211-4. Also Med. Rec, N. Y, 1937, 145: 57—Monicr- Vinard. Les anesthesies dans l'hemiplegie cerebrale. Ence- phale, 1913, 2: 165-9.—Mussio-Fournier, J. C, Cervino, J. M, & Castiglioni, C. A. Hyperalgesie bilaterale transitoire avec des reflexes hyperalgiques chez un hemipiegique avec aphasie de Broca. Rev. neur. Par, 1932, 39: pt 2, 693-8.—Wood, C. A. Hemiplegia. In Am. Encycl. Diet. Ophth. (Wood) Chic, 1916, 8: 5792-4. ---- Manifestation, vasomotor and tropic. DetjmiIs, J. *Les h£mioedemes chez les he- mipiegiques. 55p. 8? Par., 1907. Dtjuand, A. *Pathogenie des hemioedemes chez les hemipiegiques. 59p. 8? Montpel., 1910. Orvoen, J. *Etude sur les troubles sympathi- ques unilateraux chez les hemipiegiques. 42p. 8? Par., 1938. Becker, P. E. Warmeabgabemessungen bei cerebralen Halbseitenlahmungen. Deut. Zschr. Nervenh, 1936, 141: 279-92.—Decourt, J, & Gregoire, J. Le role des troubles sympathiques dans les arthropathies des hemipiegiques. Ann. med. Par, 1932, 31: 375-87.—Ellis, L. B, & Weiss, S. Vaso- motor disturbance and edema associated with cerebral hemi- plegia. Arch. Neur. Psychiat, Chic, 1936, 36: 362-72 — Euziere, Castagne, R. [et al.l Etude des troubles vaso-moteura dans un cas de syndrome de Brown-Sequard. Arch. Soc.sc, med. biol. Montpellier, 1935-36, 17: 148-61.—Luhan, J. A. Hemiedema in cases of hemiplegia. Arch. Neur. Psychiat, Chic, 1936, 36, 1: 42-57.—Marinescu, G., Bruch, H, & Vasi- lescu, N. Weitere Untersuchungen iiber trophische Storungen bei Hemipiegie. Zschr. klin. Med, 1936, 130: 768-73.—Olsen, A. [Hemiplegia, and temperature of the skin] Hospitals- tidende, 1933, 76: 1097-103.—Parhon, C, & Goldstein, M. Sur quelques troubles vaso-moteurs dans l'hemiplegie. Rou- manie med, 1899, 7: 99-117.—Perisson, J. Les troubles sympathiques dans l'hemiplegie. Ann. med. Par, 1926, 20: 560-71.—Rosenzweig, A. M, & Dervicier, L. V. Osseo-trophic disorders in hemiplegia of vascular origin. Nevropat. psikhiat, 1938, 7: 97-105.—Rouquier. Troubles sympathiques reflexes k forme hemipiegique sequelles d'un traumatisme benin remontant a 2 ans. Rev. med. est, 1935, 63: 514.—Skvortsoy, I. I. [Dynamic changes of the temperature of the skin in hemiplegias] Nevropat. psikhiat, 1936, 5: 761-80.—Smith, A. P. Erythromelalgia consequent to hemiplegia; with report of a case. Med. J. & Rec, 1931, 133: 581-5.— Strurup, G, Bolton, B. [et al.] Vasomotor responses in hemipiegie patients. Brain, Lond, 1935, 58: pt 4, 456-69.—Villaret, M, Rubens- Duval, A, Pequignot, H. Consideratiosn sur la gangrene dimidiee des extremites chez les hemipiegiques (k propos d'un cas d'hemipiegie gauche avec gangrene homolaterale du membre inferieur) Paris med, 1937, 105: 421-3—Watanabe, T. Ueber den Wasser- und Eiweissaustausch durch die Kapillar- wand der gelahmten Extremitat bei Hemiplegikern. Tohoku J. Exp. M., 1938, 34: 133-45. HEMIPLEGIA 497 HEMIPLEGIA ---- neurotic. See also Chorea; Hysteria; Migraine; Neurosis; Psychoneurosis. Samson, J. [W. H.] *Hysterische Hemi- und Paraplegien [Munster] 38p. 8? Krumbach (Schweben) 1933. Barraquer Farre, L. Diagn6stico de la hemiplejia histerica. Ars medica, Barcel, 1929,5: 63-5.—Bcttolo, A. Un interessante caso di emiplegia isterica. Pensiero med, 1928, 8: 48.—Chick. D. A case of assumed hemiplegia. Mag. London School M. Women, 1916, 11: 111-5— DuprS, E, & Rist. Hemipiegie hysterique chez un cuirassier. Rev. neur. Par, 1914, 22: 200.—Fernandez Sanz, E. Un caso de hemiplegia historica. Rev. clin. Madrid, 1909, 1: 374-7.------■ Hemiplegia histero- traumatica. Ibid, 2: 448-54.—Noica. Suffit-il de vouloir pour simuler une hemipiegie hysterique? Rev. neur. Par, 1931, 38: 75-8.—Oesterlen, O. Hysterische oder organische Hemi- piegie. Aerztl. Sachverst. Ztg, 1933, 39: 29-35.—Oliver. Girl with functional hemiplegia; face involved; anaesthesia. Northumberland M. J, 1896, 4: 108.—Roccavilla, A. Emi- plegia istero-organica da trauma in opposta regione parieto- temporale. Gazz. osp, 1918, 39: 593-6.—Rouquier, A. Les hemipiegies hysteriques ou pithiatiques. Gaz. hop, 1931, 104: 1581-7. —---- Lhermitte, J, & Trclles, J. Hemipiegie do type dit hysterique ou pithiatique manifestation initial d'un gliome du corps calleux; etude clinique; etude anatomique. Rev. neur. Par, 1932, 39: 448-59. ---- Pathology. Mikulski, J. *Ueber cerebrale Hemiplegien ohne anatomischen Befund [Zurich] 32p. 8? Berl., 1909. Boxwell, W. Brain from a case of hemiplegia. Tr. R. Acad. M. Ireland, 1915, 33: 382.—Clark, W. E. L, & Russell, D. S. Atrophy of the thalamus in a case of acquired hemiplegia associated with diffuse porencephaly and sclerosis of the left cerebral hemisphere. J. Neur. Psychiat, Lond, 1940, n. ser, 3: 123-40.—Greppi. E, & Redaelli, P. Emiplegia senza focolaio; epicrisi anatomo-clinica. Minerva med. Tor, 1935, 26: 663-7.—Hall, G. W. Crossed paralysis. Med. Clio. N. America, 1334, 17: 1491-3.—Homen, E. A. Fall af hemiplegi, hemianastesi och hemianopsi med sektion. Fin. lak. sail, hand, 1910, 52: 512.—Karnosh, L. J. Hemiplegia; some of its pathologic and clinical features. J. Kansas M. Soc, 1938, 39: 281-5.—Marburg, O. Die dynamische Komponente cerebralei Hemiplegien. Fol. neuropath, eston, 1925, 3:-4: 11-4.— Schilder, P. Beobachtungen an leichten Hemiparesm. Deut. Zschr. Nervenh, 1930, 114: 95-103.—Teufl, R. Kasuistische Beitrage zur Frage der anatomisch substratlosen Hemiplegien. Wien. klin. Wschr, 1939, 52: 670-4.—Verduzan & Latreille, G. Cerveau d'hemipiegique. J. med. Bordeaux, 1907, 37: 705. ---- Peduncular syndromes [Benedict; Foville; Weber, &c] Alurralde, M, & Sepich, M. J. Sindromo ponto-peduncular (tipo Weber) Prensa med. argent, 1927, 14: 1-5. Sindromo de la calota pedtincolo-pontina tipo Foville. Ibid, 1928, 15: 841-6.—Amir, M. [Alternating hemiplegias] Ned. tschr. geneesk, 1930, 74: 2634-9.—Babinski. Hemipiegie post-spasmodique (ou hemichoree post-hemipiegique) Rev. gen. clin. ther, 1915, 29: 107.—Bonorino Udaondo, C, & Pinedo, C. Syndrome de Weber avec hemianopsie bilaterale homonyme. Bull. Soc. med. hop. Paris, 1927, 3. ser, 51: 1669-73.—Chukry, I. Sur un cas de pseudo-syndrome de Weber. Rev. otoneur. Par, 1927, 5: 557.—Claude, H, & Lejonne, P. Paralysie alterne associee k un syndrome spas- modique, du probablement k une lesion irritative du faisceau genicuie. Rev. neur. Par, 1907, 20: 744-6.—Coppez, J. H. Interventions sur les paupieres dans un cas de paralysie alterne du type Foville. J. beige neur. psychiat, 1935, 35: 206-8.— Cremieux, A. Les syndromes pedonculaires. Prat. med. fr, 1931, 12: 461-71.—Cunge, J. Syndrome pedonculaire avec nystagmus vertical et hemipiegie; nystagmus vertical dans la convergence. Rev. neur. Par, 1935, 42: pt 2, 408.—De Giacomo, U. Rarissimo tipo di paralisi alterna inferiore. Riv. pat. nerv, 1930-31, 35: 1-9.—Dimitri, V. Hemiplejia alterna superior; observation an&tomo-clinica. Rev. As. med. argent, 1939, 53: 1109^13.—Dupre, E, & Leger. Hemichoree post- hemipiegique alterne. Rev. neur. Par, 1907, 15: 743.— Euziere & Margarot. Syndrome de Benedict. Montpellier med, 1910, 31: 20.—Gayarre. Un caso de par&lisis alterna. Rev. med. cir. pract, Madr, 1907, 76: 27-9.—Gaztelu, T. Un caso de hemiplejia izquierda y oftalmoplejfa bilateral. Rev. iber. amer. cienc. med, 1912, 28: 223-8.—Guillain, G, Thevenard, A, & Thurel, R. Syndrome de la calotte protu- berantielle caracterise par un double syndrome de Foville; origine infectieuse probable. Rev. neur. Par, 1927, 34: 054- 61.—Guthrie, L. G, & Mayou, S. Right hemiplegia and atrophy of left optic nerve. Proc. R. Soc. M, Lond, 1907-8, 1: elm. sect, 180-4.—Jayle, G. E, & Ourgaud, A. G. Le syndrome di Foville atypique. Arch, opht. Par, 1939, n. ser, 3: 31-9.— Jelliffe, S. E. Superior alternate hemiplegia; Gubber-Webei type. Interstate M. J, 1908, 15: 715-22.—JumentiS. Con- tribution h l'etude des fibres aberrantes de la voie pedonculaire et de la ciegenerescenco de la pyramideetdu ruban de Reib dans ,.? f i,n„e I 4taRe anterieur du pont. Rev. neur. Par, 1909, 17: 670-2.—Levi, L, & Pechin. Un cas de syndrome de Benedict. Ibid, 1907, 15: 740-2.—Massary, E. de, Bertram!, i. Let al.J isyndrome pedonculaire caracterise par une paralysie du moteur oculaire commun et un hemisyndrome cerebelleux alterne avec tremblement du membre superieur; terminaison par memngite tuberculeuse. Ibid, 1929, 36: pt 2, 707-11 — Morsier, G. de. Syndrome de Parinaud avec hemipiegie gauche; Iaterahsation k droite de la synergie oculopalpebrale. Rev otoneur. Par, 1936, 14: 043-7.—Mutch, J. R. Foville's syndrome; record of a case. Brit. J. Ophth, 1939, 23: 225-38 — Obstandcr, E. [Case of Weber-Gubler paralysis] Polska gaz. lek, 1928, 7: 29. Also Mschr. Psychiat, 1928, 67: 64-70.— X?°nd' L" syndrome alterne oculo-hemipiegique. Presse med. 1935, 43: 1715.—Raymond. Hemipiegie spasmodique et hemichoree. J. med. int., Par, 1907, 11: 250.------ L'hemichoree post-hemipiegique. Rev. gin. clin. ther, 1907, 21: 769.—Remond, A, & Colombies. Hemipiegie avec hemi- choree. Rev. med. Par, 1922, 39: 107-10—Roger, H, Alliez, J., & Paillas, J. Hemipiegie alterne pedonculo-protu- betantielle, avec atteinte des III, V, VI, VII, VIII", nerfs craniens, et troubles de la statique. Rev. otoneur. Par, 1934, 12: 357-9.—Roger, H, Jayle, G. E, & Paillas, J. Syndrome de Parinaud par hypertonic des inferogyres et spasme des releveurs chez un hemipiegique gauche. Ibid, 1936, 14: 190-7.— Souques, Crouzon & Bertrand, I. Revision du syndrome de Benedict II propos de 1'autopsie d'un cas de ce syndrome; forme tremo-choreo-atheto'ide et hypertonique du syndrome du noyau rouge. Rev. neur. Par, 1930, 37: pt 2, 377-417.— Spota, B. R. Sindrome frustro de Weber. Prensa med. argent, 1933-34, 20: 2557-62.—Terzani, A. Le paralisi alterne. Riv. clin. med, 1930, 31: 653; 720.—Urechia, C. I. Un cas de syn- drome de Foville simplifie. Rev. neur. Par, 1927, 34: 102.— Vercelli, G. Sindrome peduncolo-protuberanziaie con iper- tensione endocranica di probabile natura infettiva ed a rapida risoluzione. Riv. otoneur, 1934, 11: 283-91.—Yaskin, J. C. A case of left hemiparesis with aphasia and with choreiform movement in the paralyzed side. Arch. Neur. Psychiat, Chic, 1927, 18: 130-2. ---- Physiopathology. Bourguignon, G. La chronaxie du faisceau pyramidal k Vital normal et dans l'hemiplegie. J. med. fr, 1931, 20: 325- 7.—Bychowski, L. Pourquoi certains hemipiegiques ne peu- vent-ils pas soulever simultanement les 2 jambes? Rev. neur. Par, 1907, 15: 1070-2.—Fedorova, E. A. [Neurohumoral regulation in hemiplegia; role of the sympathetic nervous system in glutathione metabolism] Nevropat. psikhiat, 1936, 5: 2039-48.—Feldman, E. A. [Biochemical asymmetry in hemiplegia] Vrach. delo, 1941, 23: 129-32.—Kadono, S., Maeda, S. [et al.] Ueber den intermediiiren Stoffwechsel bei Hemipiegie. Psychiat. neur. jap, 1938, 42: 61.—Oden, R, Franz, S. I. On cerebral motor control: the recovery from experimentally produced hemiplegia. Psychobiology, 1917-18, 1: 33-49. Also repr.—Paulian, D, Tudor, M, & Constanti- nesco, G. Contributions k l'etude des variations chronaxiques dans l'hemiplegie. Arch, neur, Bucur, 1939, 3: 334-40. ---- pontine. See also subheadings Peduncular syndromes; Protuberantial syndromes; also Pons. Donath, J. Pons-AlTektion mit wechselstiindigen motori- schen und sensiblen Lahmungserscheinungen und Konvergenz- liihmung, nebst Bemerkungen iiber die Centren der associirten Augenbewegungen. Wien. Klin. ther. Wschr, 1903, 10: 1459; 1487.—Gairdner, W. T. Two cases of hemiplegia due to sof- tening in the pons. Tr. Glasgow Path. Clin. Soc, 1899-1900, 8: 86-91.—Luque, O, & Laje Weskamp, R. Consideraciones sobre un caso de sindrome pontino. Prensa med. argent, 1920, 13: 676-9.—Ottonello, P. Contributo alia conoscenza delle sindromi rare da rammollimento pontino; variety pseudo- capsulare della sindrome delle arterie paramediane pontine. Riv. pat. nerv, 1931, 37: 273-92—Rabinowitsch, J S Zur Klinik der pontobulbaren Syndrome. Mschr. Psychiat, 1930, 75: 107-26.—Rossi, V. Sindromi di Foville, Bernard-Horner, Jackson per glioma bulbo-protuberanziale (contributo clinico istopatologico e morfologico) Arch, ottalm, 1928, 35: 173-82. Also Fol. med. Nap, 1928, 14: 44-52.—Valdes Anciano, J. A. Hemiplegia medular de origen traumatico; caso clinico presen- tado d la Academia. An. Acad, cienc. med. Habana, 1909-10,46: 488-90, 2 pl.—Worster-Drought, C. Case of pontine lesion of traumatic origin with alternate paralysis (approximating to but distinct from Millard-Gubler-Foville syndrome) Proc. R. Soc. M, Lond,1923-24, 17: Sect. Neur, 56. ---- progressive. Batten, F. E. Case of slowly progressive right hemiplegia suggesting tumour (operation; no tumour found) Proc. R. Soc. M, Lond, 1911, 4: Neur. Sect, 45.—Fry, F. R. Progres- sive hemiplegia due to gliosis and vascular lesion of the right centrum and cortex. J. Nerv. Ment. Dis, 1908, 35: 530.— Harris W. Case of slowlv progressive hemiplegia. Proc. R. Soc M, Lond, 1907-8, 1: Neur. Sect, 5-7— Ramond, L. Diagnostic etiologique d'une hemipiegie k debut progressif. 227475—vol. 7, 4th semes---32 HEMIPLEGIA 4< Presse med, 1934, 12: 1909.—Tooth, II. H. Caso of progressive double hemiplegia. Proc. R. Soc. M, Lond, 1912-13, 6: Neur. Sect., 140. ---- Proluberantial syndromes [Millard-Gub- ler, &c] Andre-Thomas & Amyot, R. Syndrome protuberantiel posterieur direct; paralysie de la Vl'et de la VH'paires gauches, hemi-syndrome cerebelleux gauche; paralysie laterale du regard; asvnergie df s mouvements de la tete el des yeux. Rev. neur. Par, 1929, 36: pt 2. 507-71.—Bernstein. Halbseitiger Haar- ausfall und halbscitige Pigmentverschiebung im Gesicht und am liaise und sklerodcimieahnliche Hautveranderung an der kontralateralen Seite bei einer Hemiplegia alternans facialis, Typ Millaid-C.ubler. Munch, med. Wschr, 1927, 74: 383.— Bollack, J. Svndrome de la partie inferieure de la calotte protuberantielle avec paralvsie des mouvements de lateralite iles venx. Rev. neur. Par, 1924, 31: 336-41.- Braelt & Vincent, (!. Ln cas de syndrome protuberantiel avec ln'mi- anesthesie dissociee de forme anormale; hemiaiaxie du cote oppose a la lesion: paralysie des mouvements de lateralis des yeux. Ibid, 1912, 20: pt 2, 1-7.—Brugi, A. La sindrome motricc alterna di Millaid-Gubler (considerazioni generali ed illustrazione di un caso clinico) Pensiero med, 1928, 17: 573-87.—Cacciapuoti, G. B. Sopra una speciale sindrome piotuberanziale. Ricer. nevr, Catania, 1913, 557-78.— Claude, IL, Schaeffcr, H, & de Laulerie. Syndrome pro- tulieiantie! >ui iricur de la region de la calotte: paralysie double de la >ixi( me paire, avec asyncrgie generalisee, et hemianesthe- sie dissociee k type syringomyeiique. Rev. neur. Par, 1921, 28: 73-7.— (ornil, I, Tumour protuberantielle; regression du syndrome do Milla.d Gubler par la decompression et la radio- therapie. Ibid, 1928, 35: 417-9.—D'Espine. Un cas d'hemi- piegie droite avec deviation conjuguee de la tete et des yeux, due a un tubercule de la protuberance. Korbl. Schweiz. Aerzte, 1915, 45: 591.—Dide & Peytou. Syndrome protuberantiel posterieur bilateral. Encephale, Par, 1922, 17: 563-7, pl.— Duhot E, ens des attitudes. Montpellier med, 1920, 42: 38-43.—Spota, B. B, & Alurralde, A. J. Sindrome de Millard- Gubler; obseivacion clinica. Prensa med. argent, 1941, 2*: 594-8.—Lrechia, C. I. Sur un cas de syndrome de la calotte protuberantielle. Rev. neur. Par, 1936, 65: 651-4.—Van Bogaert, L, & Helsmoortel, J, jr. Un cas de myoclonies facio- palato-pharyngo-laryngees au cours d'un syndrome de Millard- tlubler-Foville. Ann. mal. oreille, 1926, 45: 39-44. Also repr. ---- Psychology. Lohmaxn, A. M. Ein Fall von Phantomer- scheinungen bei einer linksseitigen Hemipiegie [Halle] 18p. 8? Lpz., 1935. Also Deut. Zschr. Nervenh, 1935, 136: Gurko, G. [Experimental psychological investigalions of patients with hemiplegia of capsular or cortical origin) Obozr. psichiat. nevr, S. Peterb, 1912, 17: 73-93.—Pavlovski! [Hemiplegia in a woman with persistent laughter] Med. pribav. k morsk. sborn, S. Petersb, 1906, 209.—Pineas, H. Ein Fall von phantomahnlichen Erscheinungen (Phantom- arm) bei hemiplegischer Lahmung. Nervenarzt, 1932 5- 233-6. ---- recurrent. See also Neurosyphilis. Babonneix, L, dc Riom, C. Hemipiegie recidivante liee sans doute a l'heredo-syphilis. Gaz. hop, 1933, 106: 913.__ HEMIPLEGIA Cabot, R. ('. Recurrent hemiplegia in a young man. N England J. M, 1929, 200: 196-9. ---- Reflexes. Meunier, C. *Le reflexe palpdbral ou mioux le reflexe corn6o-conjonctival dans I'h6mipl6gie G4p. 8? Par., 1909. Borowsky, M. L. Der Blinzelabwohrreflcx, sein biolo- gisches Wesen und seine Veranderungen ids neues Symptom bei Hemipiegie. Deut. Zschr. Nervenh, 1929, 110: 134-50.— Bramwell, B. Left-sided hemiplegia with crossed plantar reflex. Clin. Stud, Edinb, 1907, n. ser, 5: 249-51.- Duii- denkov, S. Reflexes de defense, reproduisant le syndrome de la soidisant surreilectivite hypcralgesique, dans un cas d'hemi- piegie reientc par thrombose arterielle. Rev. neur. Par 1920. 33: 614-8.—Ehlers. H. The blinking reflex in heiiii- plegios. Acta psvehial. neur, Kbh, 1929, 4: 17-50.—Margues, A. Les reflexes (oniques chez les hemipiegiques. Rev. neur Par, 1920, 33: 590-604.—Morsier, G. dc. Reflexe de pre- hension forcee avec abolition des mouvements volontaircs au cours d'une hemipiegie gauche. Rev. otoneur. Par, 1938, IB: 122-4.—Murray, G. Case of hemiplegia, illustrating Babinski'a toe reflex. Northumberland Durham M. J, 1900, 8: 26-9.— Nathan, D. Hemiplegia associated with presence of abdominal reflexes. Arch. Neur. Psychiat, Chic, 1937, 37: 469.— Neiding, M. N. Ueber einseitige Herabsetzung des Patellar- reflcxes bei der Hemipiegie. Mschr. Psychiat, 1929, 72: 238-44.—Osipov, V. P. [Value of Babinski's reflex as an early symptom of di case of the pyramidal tracts in the brain, and its importance in the differential diagnosis between the hemiplegia of organic and functional origin| Obozr. psichiat. nevr, S. Peterb, 1903, 8: 4SX-507. Pisk, G. Leber ein eigenartiges Phiinomen der Bauehmuskulatur bei Hemiplegia. Med. Klin, Berl, 1930, 32: 770-2. Poppi, U. Comporta- mento paradossale del riflesso medio-pubieo nella emiplegia. Riv. pat. nerv, 1927, 32: 209-73.—Wegener, H. Dor gc- kreuzte Adduktorenreflex. Mschr. Psychiat, 1927, 66: 342-55. ---- spastic. Maniadis, G. Contribution a l'etude de I'h6mipl6gie spasmodique infantile d'origine h6r6- dosyphilitiquc. 127p. 8? Par., 1934. Alessandri, R. Emiplegia spastica ed emipoestesia destra consecutive a compressione della zona media del giro parietale sinistro da frattura avvallafa del parietale; operazione; miglio- ramento notevole. Clin, chir, Milano, 1916, 24: 328-30.— Bouchaud. H6mipiegie cerebrale spasmodique survenue k I'fige de 12 ans; arret de developpement des membres paralyses; hemiataxie; hemianosthesie. J. sc. med. Lille, 1908, 2: ,">r).1; 529. Also Rev. med. Par, 1908, 28: 20-37.—Brouwer. II. Over hemiplegia spastica infantilis. Ned. tschr. geneesk, 1917, 1: 1400.—Cauvy, G. L'hemiplegie spasmodique. Bull. Soc. m6d. Paris, 1937, 240-4. Also J. med. Paris, 1937, 57: 579-81.—Haliprc, A. Hemipiegie spasmodique infantile; sclerose cerebrale atrophique. Normandie med, 1912, 28: 12-4.—Johncr, T. Zur Symptomatologie der motorischen Ilirnrogion; spastisch-atonische Hemipiegie. Deut. Zschr. Chir, 1938, 250: 078-91. ------ Spastisch-atonische Hemi- piegie, ein bei Extradural-haematom mehrfach beobachtetca Symptombild. Helvet. med. acta, 1938, 5: 798-802—Justin- Besancon, L, & Sftze, S. de. Les indications des cures hydro- minerales dans les hemipiegies spasmodiques. Presse therm. clim, 1938, 79: 249-51.—Mathieu, P. Le traitement de l'hemiplegie spasmodique par la dieiectrolyse, ionisation. Ibid, 251-3.—Mikulowski, V. Emiplegia spastica e lue con- genita ncH'infanzia. Riv. clin. pediat, 1928, 26: 809-14.— Noica & Caffe, L. Sur une phenomene d'hyperexcitabilite medullaire de la paroi abdominale du cote malade, chez lea hemipiegiques spasmodiques. Rev. neur. Par, 1927, 34: pt 2, 521-3.—Noica & Marbe, S. Sur la dissociation des reflexes tendineux et cutanes dans les hemipiegies organiques spasmodiques. Ibid, 1907, 15: 93-5.—Perkins, G. Case of spastic hemiplegia. Proc. R. Soc. M, Lond, 1922-23, 16: Sect. Stud. Dis. Child, 75-8.—Preobrazhenski, P. A. K'ase of hemiplegia infantilis spastica with athetoid cortical epilepsy] Vrach. Zapioki, Moskva, 1899, 6: 224-7.—Ruschen- burg, E. Erfahrungen mit der Stoffelschen Operation zur Beseitigung des Spitzfusses bei spastischer zerebraler Hemi- piegie. Zschr. Orthop, 1937, 66: 377-95.—Scheid, W. Daa Syndrom der spastischen Hemipiegie bei den akut entziind- lichen, mit Entmarkung einhergchenden Erkrankungen des Nervensystems. Nervenarzt, 1940, 13: 289-301.—Spastic hemiplegia; laminectomy; improvement. S. Thomas Hosp. Rep, Lond, 1905, n. ser, 33: 202.—Straaten, J. J. van [In- fantile progressive spastic hemiplegia] Ned. tschr. geneesk, 1930, 74: pt 2, 6157; 1931, 75: 1377. ---- spinal. See also Brown-Sequard's syndrome; Spinal cord, Disease, &c. Kaplan, D. *Die Theorien zur Deutung dea Brown-Sequard'schen Symptomenkomplexes. 16p. 8? Stetten-Basel, 1935. HEMIPLEGIA 499 HEMIPLEGIA Mills, C. K. Unilateral ascending paralysis and unilateral descending paralysis; their clinical varieties and their pathological causes. 22p. roy. 8? [Chic] 1906. Palma, J. de. Contribution a l'dtude de l'hemiplegie spinale ascendante chronique. 57p. 8? Par., 1936. Barker, L. F. Incomplete Bro\vn'-S6quard paralysis. Am Med, 1930, 42: 284-8.—Beriel, L. L'hemiplegie spinale sans troubles de la sensibilite. Lyon med, 1926, 138: 164-70 — Boisseau, Vian & Touati. Syndrome de Brown-Sequard k bascule passager avec syndrome dc Claudc-Bernard-liomer. Rev. otoneur. Par, 1936, 14: 306-9.—Castro, A. de, & Cou- tinho, E. Syndrome de Brown-Sequard de causa syphilitica. Brasil med," 1933, 47: 779-82.—Christiansen, V. [Case of spinal hemiplegia] Ugeskr. laeger, 1927, 89: 618-23.—Cottin, E, & Saloz, C. Le syndrome de Brown-Sequard. Rev. med. Suisse rom, 1936, 56: 221-45.—Gajkiewicz. [Brown-Sequard's traumatic paralysis of the spine] Neur. polska, 1911, 2: 94.—Gordon, A. A case of descending unilateral paralysis. J. Nerv. Ment. Dis, 1908, 35: 570.—Greidenberg, G. Note sur l'hemiiesio'n de la moelle, syndrome de Brown-Sequard post-traumatique. C. rend. Congr. alien, neur. France, 1911, 21. Congr, 261-78.—Guillain, G, Thevenard, A., & Decourt, J. Un cas de paralysie spinale ascendante chronique a predo- minance unilaterale. Rev. neur. Par, 1927, 34: 585-98.— Hassin, G. B, Kendrick, F. J, & Connelly, E. J. Brown- Sequard paralysis; report of 2 cases (poliomyelitis and cord syphilis) J. Nerv. Ment. Dis, 1930, 72: 245-50.—Lhermitte, J, & Albessar. L'hemiplegie ascendante progressive k evolu- tion prolongee'. Gaz. hop, 1934, 107: 185-9.—Marcovitz, E. Brown-Sequard syndrome. In Cvclop. Med. (Piersol-Bortz) Phila, 1940, 14: 32-G.—Oppcnheim. Ueber Hemiplegia spinalis. Berl. klin. Wschr, 1913, 50: 1324.—Redlich, E. Brown-Sequard'sche Lahmung mit Lahmung des llalssyinpa- thicus nach Schussverletzung. Neur. Zbl, 1915, 84: 147-9.— Roques, Sorel, R. [et al.] Syndrome de Brown-Sequard consecutif k une compression medullaire pseudo-tumorale de nature syphilitique. Rev. neur. Par, 1934, 41: pt 2, 067-71.— Ruhemann, K. Ueber spastische Spinalparalyse nach Unfall. Aerztl. Sachverst. Ztg, 1913, 19: 317-21—Ziskind, E. Ascend- ing hemiplegia probably due to system disease. Bull. Los Angeles Neur. Soc, 1936, 1: 107-9. ---- Topography. See also under names of parts affected as Larynx, Paralysis; Tongue, Paralysis, &c. Audenino, E. Les paresies mimiques unilaterales chez les pcrsonnes normales, les fous et les criminels. C. rend. Congr. internat. anthrop. crim. (1906) 1908, 6. Congr, 180-4. Also Arch, psichiat. Tor, 1906, 38: 755-9.—Bee vor, C. E. On the movements of the tongue in hemiplegia, and from cortical stimulation: an apparent paradox; with a note on the move- ments of the tongue after paralvsis of one hypoglossal nerve. Brain, Lond, 1906, 29: 487-93.—Corberi, G. Sul valore di un insolito comportamento della lingua in due casi di emiplegia infantile. Ann. nevr. Nap, 1909, 27: 224-35.—Spillcr, W. G. Hemiplegia with paralysis of the neck muscles from a small myelitic lesion. J. Nerv. Ment. Dis, 1908, 35: 569. ---- Topography: Left side. Bourguignon, G, & Eliopoulos, S. Localisation de la lesion par Taction de la dieiectrolyse dans un cas d'hemipiegie gauche avec aphasie. C. rend. Soc. biol, 1931, 106: 1142-4.— Figueira, F. [Hemiplegia esquerda] Ann. Acad, med, Rio, 1905-6, 71: 197.—Hildebrandt. Dyspraxie bei linksseitiger Hemipiegie. Neur. Zbl, 1908, 27: 576.—Jude & Trabaud. Hemipiegie gauche avec anarthrie; access de fourire contrastant avec la correction de la mimique douloureuse. Rev. neur. Par, 1928, 35: 726-8.—Roch. Deux cas d'h6mipiegie gauche. Presse med, 1939, 47: 1209.—Soper, H. W. Left hemiplegia. Scient. Tr. M. Soc. City Hosp. Alumni, S. Louis (1904) 1905, 222-4.—Taylor, J. . Left hemiplegia and left nerve paralysis. Proc. R. Soc. M, Lond, 1909-10, 3: Neur. Sect, 18.—Verzilov, V. M. [Left hemiplegia with aphasia in a right-handed person] J. nevropat. psikhiat, Moskva, 1908, 8: 195-8 [Two cases of laevolateral hemiplegia with aphasia in a right- and left-handed person] Med. obozr, Moskva, 1909, 72: 230-43. ---- Topography: Right side. Amyot, R., & Saint-Germain, J. P. Hemipiegie droite et aphasie sensorio-motrice; probleme etiologique. Union med. Canada, 1934, 63: 1105-14.—Camaiier, A. Hemiplejia derecha con afasia sensorial tipo Wernicke. Dia med, B. Air, 1930-31, 3: 385-7.— Claude, H. Un cas d'hemipiegie droite avec apraxie du cote gauche, cecite verbale, agraphie, et topo- anesthesie d'origine psychique. Bull. Soc. med. hop. Paris, 1909, 3. ser, 28: 89-97.—Duperie, R. Hemipiegie droite et aphasie uremiques. J. med. Bordeaux, 1908, 38: 118-21.— Guthrie, L, & Mayou, M. S. Right hemiplegia with obstruc- tion ('/thrombosis) of the left common carotid and central artery of the retina, with perception of light in the eye. Am. hPiT&M1}- r9.08' i25= 179--Liepmann. Relative Eupraxie bei Rechtsgelahmten. Deut. med. Wschr, 1908 34- 1470 — ii??er'x> R!;lat.ive Eupraxie bei Rechtsgelahmten. Ibid, l^nm ,,',„Ln', Hemiparesie droite partielle. Presse mid 1939, 47: 1293.—Rose, F, & Touchard, P. Hemipiegie droite et apraxie gauche. Encephale, 1909, 1: 524-8 Also Rev. neur. Par 1909, 17: 591.—Soejoenoes, R. M. [Hemi- plegia dextra] Geneesk. tschr. Ned. Indie, 1940, 80: 436 — Yahn, M, & Pinto Pupo, P. Interdicao num caso de hemi- 1939a4-I217-2C5m Arq- Serv" assist Psicopat. S. Paulo, ---- transient. Nedelec, E. ^Contribution a l'etude des hemipiegies d'origine cardiaque et des hemipiegies temporaires en particulier. 42p. 8? Par., 1929. Potier, G. *Hemiplegies intermittentes essen- tielles. 72p. 8? Par., 1932. Davis, E. Temporary hemiplegia following symptomatic convulsions. Arch. Dis. Childh, Lond.-, 1939, 14: 87 — Fleming, H. W, & Naftiger, H. C. Physiology and treatment of_transient hemiplegia. J. Am. M. Ass, 1927, 89: 1484-7.— Hirtz, E, & Beaufume. Hemipiegie transitoire chez une cardia- que avec gros foie et ascite, disparaissant rapidement par ponction d'ascite; pathogenic. Bull. Soc. med. hop. Paris, 1910, 3. ser, 2i>: 734-40.—Kaufmann, E. Transitorische Hemipiegie. Deut. med. Wschr, 1929, 55: 184.—Manheimer-Gonmes. Hemipiegie intormittente d'origine albuminuriquo chez une fillette. C. rend. Congr. med. alien, neur. France, 1905, 15. Congr, 2: 308-10.—Pagniez, P, Plichet, A, & Camus, P. Hemiparesie transitoire k rechutes, durant pendant 6 annees, et suivie de paralysie oculaire durable; syphilis cerebro-meningee. Bull. Soc. med. hop. Paris, 1937, 3. ser, 53: 1391-3.—Ravid, I. M. Transient insulin hypoglycemic hemiplegias. Am. J. M. Sc, 1928, 175: 756-69—Webb, G. L. A case of migraine accompanied by temporary hemiplegia. West London M. J, 1910, 15: 318.—Weiss, S. The nature and management of cerebral hemiplegia in patients with arterial hvpertension. Med. Clin. N. America, 1929, 13: 111-37.—Wulfften Palthe, P. M. van [Transitory hemiplegia in young Europeans in Weltevreden] Ned. tschr. geneesk, 1931, 75: pt 2, 1727-36. ---- traumatic. See also Brain, Injuries; Cranium, Fracture; Head injury. Babinski. Hemipiegie et accident du travail. Clinique, Par, 1907, 2: 538-40. ------ Certificat k propos d'une hemipiegie consecutive k un accident du travail. J. med. int., Par, 1907, 11: 259.—Camp, C. D. A case of hemiplegia follow- ing fracture of the skull, with periodic escape of cerebrospinal fluid. Tr. Clin. Soc. Univ. Michigan, 1909-10, 1: 13-6 — Canfield, R. B. A case of traumatic hemiplegia following frac- ture of the skull with periodic loss of cerebrospinal fluid from the left frontal sinus; operation; recovery. Tr. Am. Lar. Rhin. Otol. Soc, 1910, 293.—Frugoni, C. Emiplegia organica da ferita d'arma da fuoco non interessante la caviti, ni le ossa craniche, per probabile embolia cerebrale da trombosi contusiva della carotide interna. Riforma med, 1917, 33: 581.—Greiden- berg, B. S. [Hemiplegia of the spinal cord; case of traumatic Brown-Sequard's paralysis] Prakt. vrach, 1910, 9: 675; 693; 711.—Howell, B. W. Case of hemiplegia. Proc. R. Soc. M, Lond, 1921-22, 15: Sect. Stud. Dis. Child, 31.—Konig, E. Ueber homolaterale Hemipiegie bei Meningeaverletzung. Deut. Zschr. Chir, 1929, 218: 370-5.—Marchand & Samsoen. Hemipiegie post-traumatique tardive sanshemorragiemeningee. Ann. med. leg, 1934, 14: 798-800. Also Echo med. nord, 1934, 3. ser, 2: 220.—Marie, P, & Athanassio-Benisty. Hemipiegie spinale droite il la suite d'une contusion de la colonne vertebrate par une balle. Rev. neur. Par, 1914, 22: 392.—Marie, P, Levy, G. Un cas d'hemipiegie organique par commotion sans blessures. Ibid, 1917, 24: 44.—-Mateo Carreras. Hemipar&lisis del lado derecho, consecutiva a una caida de cabeza. Med. nifios, 1911, 12: 23.—Milward, F. V. A case of depressed fracture of the right parietal region with left hemiplegia in a boy, aged 6 years. Rep. Soc. Study Dis. Child, Lond, 1907-8, 8: 40-L—Ogilvie, G. Right hemiplegia following operation. Proc. R. Soc. M, Lond, 1907-8, 1: Neur. Sect, 94.—Pelle A, &Sambron. Hemipiegie traumati- que par hematome extra-dural chez l'enfant. Mem. Acad, chir. Par, 1937, 63: 1205-3.—Rimbaud, L, Anselme-Martin, G, & Cadilhac, M. A propos d'un cas d'hemipiegie post-comitiale. Arch. Soc. sc. med. biol. Montpellier, 1934-35, 16: 442-4 — Rozenfeld, F. O. [Case of hemiplegia following contusion] Prakt. vrach, 1916, 15: 327; 341—Slaughter, R. F, & Riley, G. Delayed post traumatic hemorrhage with aphasia. J. Nerv. Ment. Dis, 1940, 92: 49-54.—Souques, A. Note compie- mentaires sur Pintdret medico-legal des hemipiegies tardives traumatiques. Rev. neur. Par, 1907, 15: 408-40.—Stroh- mayer. Ueber einen Fall von traumatischer Hemiparesc. Miinch. med. Wschr, 1914, 61: 564.—Valdes Anciano, J. A. Hemiplegia medular de origen traum&tico. Rev. med. cubana, 1910, 16: 190-3.—Wharton, H. R. Hemiplegia following operation for appendicitis. Tr. Philadelphia Acad. Surg, 1908, 9: 43-5. HEMIPLEGIA 500 HEMIPLEGIA Treatment. See also Brain, Apoplexy: Treatment; Paraly- sis, Treatment. Bradford, S. S. Hemiplegia; traitement and prognosis. Med. Woman J, 1938, 45: 61-5.- Faure, M. Comment faut-il traitor les hemipiegiques? C. rend. Gongr. internat. med, 1900, 15. Congr. Sect, 141-3.— Cioja. L. Ltoria della cura di una emiplegia accompagnata da movimenti clonici. Ann. clin. Osp. incurab. Nap, 1835, 1: 207-9.—Green, A. J, & Salber. E. J. Hemiplegia treated by nicotinic acid. S. Afr. M. J, 1941, 15: 230.—Kon, D. [Effect of hcmoiherapy on hemiplegia] Warsz. czas. lek, 1936, 13: 405-5.—Maucci. O. C. Pressione arteriosa ed adrenalinemia in emiplcgici trattati idropinicamente con acqua salsobromoiodica di Sales (Voghera) Riv. idroclim, 1938, 49: 14-25.—Polzer, K. Heilung einer enzephalitischcn Hemiparese durch Betabion forte. Ther. Gegenwart, 1938, 79: 377.—Rouquier, A. Le traitement des hemipiegies syphilitiques. Bull. Soc, fr. derm, syph, 1934, 41: 796-9.------& Drouet, P. L. Le traitement des hemipiegies syphilitiques. J. med. Par, 1934, 54: 982.—SciclounofT, F. L'acetylcholine dans le traitement de l'ictus hemipiegique. Presse med, 1934, 42: 1140-2.—Sebastiani, V. L'ipodermoen- fisi ossigenata nei trattamento delle cmiplegie dolorosc. Gazz. internaz. med. chir, 1908, 11: 305-7.—Veraguth, O. Ueber Hemiplegien und ihre Behandlung. Schweiz. med. Wschr, 1930, 60: 9-13. ---- Treatment: Dielectrolysis. See also Diathermy, transcerebral. Wakili, R. G. *Sur 1'effet de la di61ectrolyse transcerebrale (Bourguignon) avec le ion calcium, sur l'index oscillometrique chez les hemipiegiques. 24p. 8? Geneve, 1936. l*ourgui>;non, G. Action de la dieiectrolyse trans-cerebrale de calcium dans l'hemiplegie. C. rend. Soc. biol, 1931, 106: 454. ------er Gewebshvperplasie der hamatopoetischer Organe. Jap. J. M. Sc, 1939, 4: Path, 25-54.—Barney, J. E>„ Hunter, F. T., & Mintz, E. R. The urological aspects of radio- sensitive tumors of the blood-forming organs. Tr. Am. Ass. Genitourin. Surgeons, 1931. 24: 413-27- Battaitlia. F. Sulle malattie sistemiche degli organi emopoictici: une comparazione delle emopatie umane con quelle trasmis.-ibili del polio. Arch. sc. med. Tor, 1929, 53: 103-87. —— & Lcinati, I, Malat- tie sistemiche trasmissibili degli organi emopoietici del polio con ricerche sugli elementi morfologici del sangue normale e loro genesi. Boll. Ist. sieroter. milan, 1929, 8: 9; 73; 183, 4 pl. Also Boll. Sez. ital. Soc. internaz. microb, 1929, 1: 14-6.— Blount, W. P. Haomocytohlastosis. Vet. J, Lond, 1939, 95: 91-102.—Critchley, M, A: Greenfield, J. G. Spinal symptoms in chloroma and leukaemia. Brain, Lond, 1930, 53: 11-37, 3 pl.—Gosio, R. f'aso di emoistioblastosi con particolare evoluzione ematologica. Bull. Accad. med. Roma, 1930, 56: 168-78.—Hagio, K. Pathologisch-anatomische Untersuchun- gen iiber die (iewebshyperplasie der blutbildenden Organe; akute Leukamic und chronische Myelose; Anhang: Erythromye- lose. Acta Scholae med. Univ. Kioto, 1939, 23:63-112, 7 pl. ------ Monocytenleukamie. Ibid, 113-25, pl. ------ Chloro- matose, Myelosarkomatose und Myelomatose. Ibid, 126-53, 4 pl. ------ Lymphadenose, Lymphosarkomatose, Lymphosar- komund Leukosarkomatose. Jap. J. M. Sc, 1939,4: Path, 131- 50, 2 pl. ------ Reticulosarkomatose, Mycosis fungoides und Lymphogranulomatose. Ibid, 151-75, 2 pl.—Langer, H. Koentcen therapy in hyperplastic blood dyscrasias; new tech- nique for myeloid and lymphatic leucemia, polycythemia rubra vera and Hodgkin's disease. Am. J. Roentff, 1935, 34: 214- •'33.— Martinolti, L. Le maoifestazioni cutanee nolle emoblastosi. Gior. ital. mal. vener, 1920, 61: 91-115. Also Tumori, Roma 1921-22, 8: 63; passim.- -Perez, R. M. SvstematKierte Reticulogranulomatose der luimopr.otiM-licn Organe mit - starker Beteiligung der Leber. Beitr. path. Anat, 1936 97- 22-40, 2 pl.—Pickhardt, O. C. Mali-rnaucies of the blood and blood forming organs. Prev. M., 1938, 8: 175-82, 204.— Pohle, E. A. Radiation therapy in medical practice; leukemia, Hodgkin's granuloma and allied diseases. Wisconsin M. J 1935. 34: 632-6- Schick, B. HemocvtoblastosLs; case j Mount Sinai Hosp. N. York, 1938-39, 5: 158— Schlittler. lTeber Granulationsgeschwiilste in der Nase bei Erkrankungen des Blutes. Internat. Zbl. Ohrenh, 1923, 21: 81.—Schwarz, G. Die Rontgeubeliandlung einiger ErUrankungon des Blutes und der blutbildenden Organe (Leukemic und Lympho- granulom) Wien. klin. Wschr, 1927, 40: IL 39, Sonderb 1-7 Also Wien. med. Wschr, 1927, 77: 1275-8.—Sternberg C I'athologi-che Anatomie der Myelosen und Lvmplioniaio^en" \\ien. klin Wschr, 1921, 34: 158—Velasco Blanco, L, Fuclis' D, AObeid, F. Sindrome hemocitoblfetico. Arch, amer med B. Air, 193b, 12: 83-6. HEMOCHROMATOSIS. I See also Anemia; Copper, Poisoning; Hemo- . globin, Metabolism; Hemoglobinuria; Hemolysis; Hemosiderin, &c. Sheldon, J. H. Haemochromatosis. 382p. ' 8? Lond., 1935. Also Lancet, Lond, 1934, 2: 1031-6. Also In Brit. Encycl M. Pract. (Rolleston, H.) Lond, 1937, 6: 106-14. 1 Veubeek, A. G. M. *Over den diabete bronzd. 97p. 8? Utrecht, 1931. Callender, G. R. Hemochromatosis. Inlernat. Clin, 1928, 38. ser, 2: 208-70. pl.—Coates, F. Hcemochromatosis, or bronzed diabetes. Tr. Ulster M. Soc, 1926-29, 126-31. - Elliott, T. R. Hemochromatosis. Proc. R. Soc. M, Lond, 1934, 27: 1237. -Evans. G. Bronzed diabetes. Ibid, 1930-31, 24: clin. seel., 177.—Finnerud, C. W, & Nomland, R. Hemo- chromatosis. Arch. Derm. Syph, Chic, 1930, 33: 931. Hartman, C. C. Hemochromatosis. Atlantic M. J, 1925 20 ■ 29: 239.—Hernandez, I. M, A Bcnnros. M. Diabetes bronce- ada. Rev. Soc. med. int., B. Air, 1925, 6: 228-40.—Mallory, F. B. Hemochromatosis. In C'vclop. Med. (Piersol-Bortz) Phila, 1939, 7: 211-3.—Meldahl, K. F. [Bronze diabetes] ' Hospitalstidende, 1935, 78: 309-28.—Sachs, A, & Russum, B. C. Hemochromatosis. Nebraska M. J, 1937, 22: 121-7.— Scheidcmandel. Bronzediabctes. Miinch. med. W.schr, 1925, 72: 457.—Smith, E. B. Hemochromatosis. Med. Times, N. Y, 1931, 59: 93.—Valente, A, & Assi.s, I, de. Hemo- cromatose. An. paul. med. cir, 19-11, 42: 521.—Varga, P. [Bronzdiabotos] Orv. hetil, 1937, 81: mell, 105-7.—Vinci- guerra, M, it Casilla, A. R. Hemochromatosis (bronzed diabetes) .1. M. Soc. N. Jersey, 1929, 26: 817-20. ---- Associated disease. Cicardo, V. H. Hemocromatosis; en un caso con cirrosis, diabetes, asistolia y astenia. Prensa m<5d. argent, 1936, 23: 1212-22.—Davidsohn, I. Hemochromatosis, thymoma, severe anemia and endocarditis in a woman. Illinois M. J, 1941, 80: 427-32.—Dekkers, H. J. N. [Case of hemochromatosis (diabiHe bronze';) combined with multiple arthritis] Ned. tschr. geneesk, 1940, 84: 4G33-8, pl.—Holmes, M. E. A case of hemochromatosis with almost complete absence of skin pig- ment, and with fatal rupture of an esophageal varix. Ann. Int. M, 1939-40, 13: 1075-81.—Hurxthal, L. M. Hemochroma- tosis as a cause of renal and suprarenal failure; a case report. Lahcy Clin. Bull, 1938-39, 1: No. 2, 9-13.—Lawrence, R. D. Haemochromatosis associated with acanthosis nigricans. Proc. R. Soc. M, Lond, 1940-41, 34: 550— Morlock, C. G. Hemo- chromatosis; report of a case in which tuberculous peritonitis was a complication. Ann. Int. M, 1939-40, 13: 2341-6.— Siemcrling, E, & Creutzfeldt, H. G. Bronzekrankheit und sklerosierende Encephalomyelitis (diffuse Sklerose) Arch. Psychiat, Berl, 1923, 68: 217-44. ---- Casuistics. Schneider, P. W. *Ueber einen Fall von Bronzediabctes. 46p. 8? Berl., 1914. Zieboldt, W. *Ueber 2 Falle von Bronze- diabetes. 24p. 8? Rostock, 1936. Abel, E, Girard, J, & Kissel, P. Etude anatomo-clinique d'un cas dc diabete bronze*. Rev. mid. est, 1933, 61: 1-11.— Barber, H. A case of haemochromatosis. Guy's Hosp. Rep, Lond, 1929, 79: 45-8. —---- Haemochromatosis in a woman. Proc. R. Soc. M, Lond, 1937-38, 31: Sect. Derm, 1352. Also Brit. J. Derm. Svph, 1938, 50: 610.—Bergh, D. van den. Diabete bronz6 fruste. Klin. Wschr, 1925, 4: 1106.—Bravctti, S. Su un caso di diabete bronzino. Gior. clin. med, 1932, 13: 89.5-905.—Bufano, M. Sopra un caso di cosidetto diabete bronzino. Policlinico, 1933, 40: sez. med, 273-93.—Butt, H. R, & Wilder, R. M. Hemochromatosis; report of 30 cases in which the diagnosis was made during life. Arch. Path, Chic, 1938, 26: 202-73—Cain. J. C. Hemo- chromatosis; report of 6 cases. Texas J. M, 1940-41, 36: 356-63.—Cann. G. A. Hemochromatosis; report of case U. S. Nay. M. Bull, 1933, 31: 305-11.—Cantarow, A, A Bucher, C. J. Hemochromatosis; report of a case. Arch. Int. M, 1941, 67: 333-44.—Coates, F. Report on case of haemochromatosis or bronzed diabetes. Ulster M. J, 1936, 5: 172-5.—Coro, A. J, & Zayas, C. Un caso de diabetes bronceada tipica. An. vias digest, Habana, 1930, 2: 75-80, ■* Pl-—Creed, J. P. Hemochromatosis; report of an early case. J Am. M. Ass., 19:5.-,, i05: 1185.—Darnall, .1. R. Hemo- chromatosis: review of the literature and report of 3 cases. Ann. Int. M, 1934-35, 8: 1121-37. Also repr. -Fiio, E. [A case of bronze diabetes] Brati.il. lek. listy, 1927, 7: 585 97. — Gans, H. M, & Adelman, A. Hemocrhomatosis; a caso report. Ohio M. J, 1941, 37: 1159-02.—Gorl, P. Zur Kasuistik der Hamochromatose. Khn. Wschr, 1927, 6: 1334-6.—Gold- berger, J. H. Hemochromatosis, with report of a case. Hosp. News, Wash, 1938, 5: No. 20, 25-32.—Gott, R, jr. Hemo- chromatosis; report of a case. J. Am. M. Ass, 1933, 101: HEMOCHROMATOSIS 503 HEMOCHROMATOSIS jg74—Hannema, L. S. Geval van haemochromatose. Ned. tschr. geneesk, 1926, 70: pt 2, 2038-43.—Harrington, A. W, & Aitkenhcad, A. C. Two cases of haemochromatosis. Glasgow M J, 1939, 132: 61-71.—Hirsch, F. Ueber einen Fall von Brnnzediabetes. Med. Klin, Berl, 1926, 22: 329-Hodges, C. M. W. Bronzed diabetes in a woman. Brit. M. J, 1929, 1- 396—Usley, M. L. Hemochromatosis; report of an early case. California West. M, 1940, 53: 217.—Kirshbaum, J. D. Hemochromatosis. In Path. Conf. (Jaffe, R. H.) Chic, 1940, 1100-2.—Lawrence, R. D. Bronzed diabetes in a woman. Lancet, Lond, 1940, 2: 489. Also Med. J. Australia, 1911, 1: 275 —Mackereth,- J. G. A case of haemochromatosis. N. Zealand M. J, 1932, 166: 408—Maling, T. C, & Riley, G. Haemochromatosis: report on a case. Ibid, 1937, 36: 314-8, pl—Manning, D. F. Hemochromatosis; with report of a case. J. Missouri M. Ass, 1925, 22: 390-3.—Miller, H. A, & Hei- mark, J. J. Hemochromatosis or bronzed diabetes, report of case. Minnesota M, 1931,14:260-2.—Miskall, E.W. Hemo- chromatosis; report of case. Ohio M. J, 1936, 32: 746.— Moeller, F. W, & Hutton, J. H. Hemochromatosis in a woman. Illinois M. J, 1926, 49: 116-8.—Murray Lyon, R. M. Haemo- chromatosis: a report on 3 cases. Brit. M. .1, 1936, 1: 1297-9 — Prado Tagle, E. Un cas de diabete bronz6. Arch. mal. app. digest. Par, 1923, 13: 340-4.—Rich, C. B. A discussion on haemochromatosis, with the report of a case. Canad. M. Ass. J, 1933, 29: 56-60.—Rose, W. J, & Bowen, B. D. A case of hemochromatosis. Bull. Buffalo Gen. Hosp, 1929, 7: 3-9.— Rushton, J. G. Hemochromatosis: report of case. Proc. Mayo Chn, 1938, 13: 110.—Sempau, S. A. Un caso dc hemocromatosis 6 diabetes bronceada. Siglo m6d, 1928, 82: 301-4.—Smith, S. W, & Blair, H. A case of haemochromatosis. Brit M. J, 1934, 1: 663.—Stepp. Fall von Hamochromatose. Med. Klin, Berl, 1927, 23: 1433.— Tedstrom, M. K. Hemo- chromatosis; report of case. California West. M, 1930, 32: 102-4.—Two cases of haemochromatosis. Med. Sc. Arch. Adelaide Hosp, 1932, No. 12, 11-3.— Vachez, L, & Chapuy, A. Etude d'un cas de diabete bronz6. Lyon mid., 1932, 149: 529-33.—Wechsler. H. F. Hemochromatosis in a woman. J. Am. M. Ass, 1934, 102: 764. ---- Chemistry, and metabolism. See also Diabetes mellitus. Dry, T. J. Hemochromatosis: its relation to the metab- olism of iron and copper. Minnesota M, 1934, 17: 301-12.— Funk, E. H, & St. Clair, H. Hemochromatosis, report of a case, with studies of the copper content of the liver. Tr. Ass. Am. Physicians, 1929, 44: 134-42.—Hausmann, M. Ueber Mela- ninurie bei Pigmentzirrhose. Helvet. med. acta, 1936, 3: 695-701.—Herzenberg, H. Ueber Hamochromatose (mit besonderer Berucksichtigung des Fe-Pigments im Gehirn) Virchows Arch, 1926. 260: 110-29.—Jacoby, M. Ueber den braunen Farbstoff bei der Hamochromatose. Biochem. Zschr, 1931, 230: 225-7.—Loeper, M., Ravier, J, & Lesure, A. Les 2 pigments du diabete bronz6. Bull. Soc. mod. hop. Paris, 1928, 3. ser, 52: 1279-83. Also Progr. med. Par, 1928, 43: 1461.—Marble, A, & Smith, R. M. Studies of iron metab- olism in a case of hemochromatosis. Ann. Int. M, 1938-39, 12: 1592-603.—Paviot, J, Chevalier, R, & Revol, L. Examen chimique d'un diabete bronz<§. Lyon mid., 1929, 144: 78-82.— Ramage, H, & Sheldon, J. H. Haemochromatosis; the content of the tissues in iron and sulphur; the results of spectro- graph^ examination with especial reference to copper and calcium. Q. J. Med, Lond, 1935, 4: 121-9, pl.—Sachs, A, Levine, V. E., & Griffith, W. O. Blood iron and copper in hemochromatosis. Proc. Soc. Exp. Biol, N. Y, 1936-37, 35: 332-5.—Sheldon, J. H. The iron content of the tissues in haemochromatosis, with special reference to the brain. Q. J. M, Oxf, 1927-28, 21: 123-37.—Stetson, R. P., & Peters, J. P. Carbohydrate metabolism in a case of hemochromatosis. Arch. Int. M, 1932, 50: 226.— Villaret, M, Justin-Besancon [et al.] La thi^mie dans les cirrhoses, en particulier dans les cirrhoses pigmentaires. Bull. Soc. mdd. hop. Paris, 1932, 3. ser, 48: 775-8. ---- Clinical aspect. Kltjt, W. *Klinische Beobachtungen an zwei Fallen von Haemochromatose. 36p. 8? Berl., 1937. ,. ., . Mayer, L. *Ein Beitrag zur Klinik des Bronzediabetes [Frankfurt] 45p. 8? Geln- hausen, 1931. , , Bonilla, E. Contribuci6n al estudio de la diabetes bronceada. Progr. clin, Madr, 1931, 39: 877-81. Also Rev. med. lat. amer, B. Air, 1931-32, 17: 1053-60. Also Rev. med hondur, 1932-33, 3: 9-14.—Campbell, M, Adler, S. S, & Hart, J. h. Biliary cirrhosis with diabetes mellitus simulating hemochro- matosis; report of a case. N. York State J. M, Ud8, repr. --Liver (The) in haemochromatosis. Melbourne Ilo-p Clin. Hep, 1930, 1: 153-5.—Lubarsch, O. Ueber Leberzirrhose, insbesondere die Pigmentzirrhose. Deut. med. Wschr, 1929, 55: 1749-51.—Orr, J. W. Primary carcinoma of liver in a case of ha-mochromatosis. Lancet, Lond, 1930, 1: 1400.—Villaret, M, & Even, R. Les cirrhoses pigmentaires du foie. Rev. med. chir. mal. foie, 1931, 6: 5-21. ——— & Justin-Besancon, I, Etude anatomo-clinique des cirrhoses picmentaires du foie: leur place dans le cadre nosolocinue des cirrhoses. Presse m, 83-95. Also Biochem. Zschr., 1925, 163: 187-90.—Ciovanardi, A. Ueber das antigene Vermogen des Hiimoglobins und iiber einige praktische Anwondungen der das llamoglobin prazipitierenden Sera. Arch. Hvg, Miinch, 1936-37, 117: 74-86.—Gussew, A. I). Versuche bohufa Erzielung spezifischer Hamoglobinpracipitine. Deut. Zschr. gerichtl. Med, 1929, 13: 270-7.—Hektoen, L, & Schulhof, K. Is the antigenic action of hemoglobin due to globin? J. Infect. Dis, 1927. 41:476-8.—Higashi, S. Serologische Untersuchun- gen iiber das Hamoglobin mit besonderer Berucksichtigung der praktischen Verwendbarkeit des Hamoglobinoprazipitins. J. Biochem, Tokyo, 1922-23, 2: 315-39.—Ishikawa, T, & Sakurabayashi, K. Sur la precipitine de l'hemoglobine. Tohoku J. Exp. M, 1925, 6: 395-8.—Mizokuti, M. [Unter- suchungen iiber die Bildung des Prazipitins und seine Artspezi- fitat bei Immunisierung mit kochkoaguliertem Hamoglobin] Hukuoka acta med, 1940, 33: 1145-74. ------ [Ueber die Bildung von Agglutinin und Hemolysin durch Injektion de- kochkoagulicrten Hiimoglobins] Ibid, 1175-84.—Nomura, S. Beitrage zur Kenrtnis iiber Hamoglobinprazipitin. J. Chosen M. Ass, 1935, 25: 69; 93.—Suzuki, K. On globin as hemo- globino-prccipitinogen. Tohoku J. Exp. M, 1935, 25: 34-62.— Wang, S. K. Adsorption of the specific precipitable substance in blood; experiments with anti-human hemoglobin precipitine. J. Orient. M, Dairen, 1937, 27: 80.------Adsorption of the specific precipitable substance in blood; experiments with anti-fowl hemoglobin precipitine. Ibid, 139.—Yasui, K. Ueber die serologische Reaktionsfiihigkeit des Hamoglobins Zschr. Immunforsch, 1929, 63: 215-30. ---- Carb-hemoglobin. See also Carbon dioxide. Henriqtjes, O. M. *Ueber Carbhamoglobin [Kobenhavn] 65p. 8? Munch., 1929. Also Erg. Physiol, 1929, 28: 625-89. Adair, G. S, Cordero, N, & Shen, T. C. The effect of temperature on the equilibrium of carbon dioxide and blood and the heat of ionization of haemoglobin. J. Physiol. Lond 1929, 67: 288-98.—Ferguson, J. K. W. Carbamino compounds of CO2 with human hemoglobin. Am. J. Physiol, 1936, 116: 18 -—■---& Roughton, F. J. W. The direct chemical estima- tion of carbamino compounds of COs with haemoglobin ,1. Physiol, Lond, 1934-35, 83: 68-86. ------ The chemical relationships and physiological importance of carbamino compounds of COj with haemoglobin. Ibid, 87-102.__ Groak, B. Beitrag zur Frage der C02-Bindung des Hamo- globins. Biochem. Zschr, 1928, 196: 478-87.—Groscurth, G, & Havemann, R. Untersuchungen iiber Carb-Hamoglobin an reduziert.-m llamoglobin. Ibid, 1935, 279: 300-13.— Hcnriqucs, O. M. 1 >n the carbon dioxide compounds in hemo- globin solutions. .]. Biol. Chem, 1931, 92: 1-11. —---. Ueber den Nachweis von komplexgcbundencm COt (Carb- hamoglobin) nn Pint. Biochem. Zschr, 1933, 260: 58-71.— Janzen, R, & Netter, H. Zur Frage der Existenz eines Carb- hamoglobins. Arch. ges. Physiol, 1933, 232: 349-56.— Margaria, R, & Green, A. A. The first dissociation constant, pK', of carbonic acid in beinosdobin solutions and its relation to the existenco of a combination of hemoglobin with carbon dioxide. J. Biol. Chem, 1933, 102: 611-34- Margaria. R, Rowinski, P., & Goldberger, S. Sullo stato del CO2 in soluzioni contenenti emoglobina. Arch. sc. biol, Bologna, 1933-34, 18: 378-84.—Osborne, W. A. The action of carbonic acid on haemoglobin. Austral. J. Exp. Biol, 1920, 3: 117. Roughton, F. J. W. Bemerkungen zu einer Arbeit von G. Croscurlh und R. Havemann iiber Carb-Hamoglobin. Biochem. Zschr, 1936, 285: 150-2.—Van Slyke, 1). D, Dillon. R. T, & Hiller, A. Crystallization of a compound of hemoglobin and carbon dioxide. Proc. Nat. Acad. Sc. U. S, 1933. 19: 828.— Warburg, O, Negelein, E, & Christian, W. Uebei' Carhylamin-IIamo- globin und die photocheinische Dissoziation seiner Kolilen- oxydverbindung. Biochem. Zschr, 1929, 214: 26-63. ---- Carboxy-hemoglobin. See also Carbon monoxide, Poisoning. Haver, H. *Ueber die Verwendbarkeit chemischer Nachwcismethoden bei Kohlenoxyd- blut [Wurzburg] 24p. 21cm. Altenb.-Thiir., 1938. Barkan, G. Das Kohlenoxyd-Pseudohamoglobin, der Spiitnachweis der Kohlenoxydvergiftung und die Frage der Kohlenoxydwirkung im tierischen Organismus. Deut. med. Wschr, 1938, 64: 638-40.—Boor, A. K. A crystallography study of pure carbonmonoxide hemoglobin. J. Gen. Physiol, 1929-30, 13: 307-16, 3 pl. Also repr. ----— & Hektoen, L. Preparation and antigenic properties of carbonmonoxido hemoglobin. J. Infect. Dis, 1930, 46: 1-11. Also repr.— Butler, J. Warum gerinnt Kohlenoxydblut nicht? Ausz. Inaugur. Diss. Med. Fak. Univ. Bern (1935-37) 1938, No. 169, 1.—Delrue, G. Purification de la carboxyhemoglobine par cristallisation. Bull. Soc. chim. biol. Par, 1938, 20: 1115.— Gorkin, Z. D. [Effect of ultra-violet radiation on the rate of dissociation of CO-Hbl J. Physiol. USSR, 1937, 22: 329-39 — Hastings, A. B, Sendroy, J. [et al.] Studies of gas and electro- lyte equilibria in blood; the effect of carbon monoxide on the acidity of hemoglobin. J. Biol. Chem, 1924, 61: 317-35 — Herzog, A. Ueber kristallisiertcs synthetisches Kohlenoxyd- hamoglobin. Biochem. Zschr, 1933, 264: 431-3.—Krauland, W. Die Pyrogallolprobe zum Nachweis von Kohlenoxyd im Blute und iiber das Bereiten von Kohlenoxydblut. Deut. Zschr. gerichtl. Med, 1940, 34: 305-7 (microfilm)—Luszczak, A. Zur Kohlenoxyd-Hamoglobin-Bestimmung mittels des Konig-Martensscben Spektralphotometers. Abh. Hyg, 1936, IL 22, 69-98.—Matthes, K, & Gross, F. Fortlaufende Rcgis- trierung von Kohlenoxydhamoglobin im stromenden Blute. Arch. exp. Path, Lpz, 1938-39, 191: 391-406.—May, J. Relation between carbon monoxide concentration in air and carbon monoxide hemoglobin content. J. Indust. Hyg, 1941, 23: Suppl. 178 (Abstr.)—Morrison, D. B., & Hisey, A. The carbon monoxide capacity, iron, and total nitrogen of dog hemoglobin. J. Biol. Chem, 1935, 109: 233-40. Also repr — Perelli, V. La determinazione cmantitativa dell'ossido di carbonio nei sangue per mezzo della fotografia aH'infrarosso. Diagn. teen, lab. Nap, 1938, 9: 407-12.—Root, R. W, & Green, A. A. The effect of acidity on the carbon monoxide- combining power of hemoglobin in the blood of marine fishes. J. Biol. Chem, 1934, 106: 545-52. Also repr.—Roughton, F. J. W. The kinetic of haemoglobin; general methods and theoretical basis for the reactions with carbon monoxide. Proc. R. Soc, Lond, 1934, 115: ser. B, 451-64.-----■ The kinetics of hemoglobin; the combination of carbon monoxide with reduced hemoglobin. Ibid, 464-73.------The kinetics of hemoglobin; the competition of carbon monoxide and oxygen for hemoglobin. Ibid, 473-91.—Schmidt, O. Der Nachweis kleinster Kohlenoxydmengen im Blut. Deut. Zschr. gerichtl. Med, 1939-40, 32: 404-6.—Sebasta, V. Ueber die Lichtabsorption des Kohlenoxydhamoglobins. Biochem. Zschr, 1933, 260: 187-91.—S^rensen, S. P. L, & S^rensen, M. Ueber die Lbslichkeit und Dissoziationstendenz tu?i Kon,enoxyd-H'imoglobins in Ammoniumsulfatlosungen. Ibid, 258: 16-47.—Truffert, L. La transparence du sang oxycarbone aux radiations infra-rouges. Bull. Soc. mid. hop. Paris, 1939, 3. ser, 55: 745-7. ---- Chemistry. Adair, G. S. The hemoglobin system. J. Biol. Chem, 1925, 63: 493; passim.—Altschul, A. M, Sidwell, A. E, jr, & Hog- ness, T. R. Note on the preparation and properties of hemo- globin. Ibid, 1939, 127: 123-9.—Anson, M. L, & Mirsky, A. E. Protein coagulation and its reversal; the preparation of completely coagulated hemoglobin. J. Gen. Physiol, 1929-30, 13: 121-43. ------ Improved methods for the reversal of the coagulation of hemoglobin. Ibid, 477-81. Also repr. ------ The identity of normal hemoglobin with the hemoglobin prepared by the reversal of coagulation, as determined by HEMOGLOBIN 507 HEMOGLOBIN Bolubility tests. Ibid, 1931, 14: 597-604.—Aszodi, Z. Ueber den Schwefelgehalt des Hamoglobins des Menschen. Biochem. Zschr, 1932, 252: 387.—Azuma, Y. [Studien fiber die Haemo- globinresistenz; die physikalisch-chemische Untersuchung; die klinische Untersuchung; die tierexperlmentelle Untersuchung] J. Chosen M. Ass, 1935, 25: 489-511.—Barkan, G, & Schales, O. Bildnngsmoglichkeiten und Eigenschaften der Pseudo- hamo-iol.ine. Zschr. physiol. Chem, 1938, 253: 83-104 — Block, R. J. The basic amino acids of 3 crystalline mammalian hemoglobins; further evidence for a basic amino acid anlage of tissue proteins. J. Biol. Chem, 1934, 105: 63-6. Also repr.—Brinkman, R, & Jonxis, J. H. P. Alkaline resistance and spreading velocity of foetal and adult types of mammalian haemoglobin. J. Physiol, Lond, 1936, 88: 163-6.—Brooks, J. The action of nitrite on haemoglobin in the absence of oxygen. Proc. R. Soc, Lond.,1937, ser. B, 123: 368-82.—Brooks, M. M. Infrared spectrophotometric studies on hemoglobin as affected by cyanide, methylene blue and carbon monoxide. Am. J. Physiol, 1941, 132: 311-20.—Fischer, H. Ueber den Dualis- mus des Blutfarbstoffs und iiber Porphyrine. Strahlentherapie, 1924, 18: 185-200. ------ & Schneller, K. Beitrag zur Kenntnis des Blutfarbstoffs. Zschr. physiol. Chem, 1923, 128: 230-9.—Gorin, M. H, Abramson, H. A, & Moyer, L. S. The effect of phosphate buffers on the electrical mobility of hemo- globin. J. Am. Chem. Soc, 1940, 62: 643.—Greulich. W. W, Day, H. G. [et al.] Forms of hemoglobin. Monogr. Soc. Res. Child Develop, 1938, 3: No. 2, 99.—Hamsik, A. [Prosthetic grouping of the coloring matter of the blood] Spisy Lek. Fak, Masaryk. Univ., 1928, 6: 105-11.—Hand, D.B. The molec- ular weight and volume of hemoglobin in urea solutions. J. Biol. Chem, 1935, 109: p. xl.—Haurowitz, F. Zur Chcmie des Bhitfarbstoffes; iiber die chemische Natur des Kathamo- globins. Zschr. physiol. Chem, 1924, 137: 62-77. ------ Ueber das Verhalten der prosthetischen Gruppe in verschie- denen Losungsmitteln. Ibid, 1927, 169: 235; 1928, 173: 118. -----Zur Chemie des Blutfarbstoffes; iiber das Hamoglobin des Menschen. Ibid, 1929-30, 186: 141-7, pl.—Herzog, A. Ueber den Einfluss von Lauge auf Teichmannsches Hamin, Hamatoprosthetin und Hamoglobin. Biochem. Zschr, 1935, 280: 156-60.—Jirgensons, B. Die Koagulation des Hamo- globins in Gegenwart von Alkoholen. Kolloid Zschr, 1927, 41: 331; 42: 59; 1928, 44: 76. ------ Die Koagulation des Hamoglobins in Gegenwart von organischen Stoffen. Biochem. Zschr, 1928, 193: 109-21.------■ Beitrage zur Kolloidchemie der Hamoglobine. Ibid, 194: 140; 200: 331. ------ Re- versible Umwandlungcn des Kathamoglobins. Ibid., 198: 206-8.—Jonxis, J. H. P. On the spreading of different haemo- globins, muscle haemoglobins and cytochrome C. Biochem. J, Lond, 1939, 33: 1743-51.—Kono, H. On the influence of salts upon the dissociation curve of haemoglobin. Jap. J. M. Sc, 1931, 2: Biophvs, 1-24—Kiister, W. Ueber den Blutfarb- stoff. Chem. Zeile, 1926, 13: 50-79.------Individuelle Blutuntersuchungen; iiber das Entstehen der Hamine aus dem Hamoglobin A und iiber die Existenz zweier Hamoglobine A a und A b. Zschr. physiol. Chem, 1926, 151: 56-85. ------ Gerlach, A, & Schoder, F. Beitrage zur Kenntnis der pros- thetischen Gruppe des Blutfarbstoffs; iiber individuelle Blut- untersuchungen. Ibid, 1924, 133: 150-7—Kiister, W., & Kimmich, K. Ueber den Blutfarbstoff. Ibid, 1927, 172: 199- 224.—Lambert, P, & Fautrez, J. Etude sur la dispersion de I'hemoglobine. Protoplasma, Lpz, 1936, 23: 220-33.— Laporta, M. Sul peso molecolare della emoglobina. Arch. sc. biol, Bologna, 1931-32, 16: 198-210.—Millikan, G. A. The kinetics of blood pigments: haemocyanin and haemoglobin. J. Physiol, Lond, 1933, 79: 158-79.—Nakamura. T. Beitrag zur physikalisch-chemischen Kenntnis des Hamoglobins. Mitt. Med. Akad. Kioto, 1940, 29: 307-10.—Nicloux, M., & Roche, J. Etude de la reaction du ferricyanure de potassium sur I'hemoglobine, l'oxyhemoglobine, I'hemoglobine oxycar- bonee et teneur en oxygfine de la methemoglobine. C. rend Soc. biol, 1925, 93: 1373-6.—Northrop, J. H-, & Anxon, M. L. A method for the determination of diffusion constants and the calculation of the radius and weight of the h'-moglobin molecule. J. Gen. Physiol, 1928-29, 12: 543-54.—Paic, M, & Deutsch, % . Adsorption de proteides; influence de la concentration des ions hydrogene sur l'adsorption de I'hemoglobine par le kaolin. C. rend. Acad, sc, 1936, 202: 1283-5.----— Adsorption de proteides; influence de sels sur l'adsorption de 1 hemoglobine par le kaolin. Ibid, 1514-6.—Philipp, K. Untersuchungen uber die Resistenz des Hamoglobins verschiedener Blutarten gegenuber Natronlauge von verschiedener Konzentiation. Zschr. vergl. Physiol, 1932-33, 18: 459-73.—Poliakov, A. Zur Frage der Struktur der Hamoglobinmolekel; die N-Verteilung in der Hamoglobinmolekel des Pferdebluts. Biochem. Zschr, 1929, 204: 88; 97.—Fortes. Sur quelques procedes d extraction et de concentration de la matiere colorante du sang. Bull. Son. sc. med. biol. Montpellier, 1922-23, 4: 91-3.—Pupko, S L. Viskosimetrische Untersuchungen der Hamoglobmkoagulation. Kolloid Zschr, 1929, 49: 150-3— Roberts, R. G, & Miller, C. O. Reactions of hemoglobin and hematin with sodium in liquid ammonia. Proc. Soc. Exp. Biol, N. Y, 1934,31: 522-4.— Roche, J. Recherches sur les combinaisons du groupement prosthetique de I'hemoglobine avec I'oxyg6ne et avec 1 oxyctc de carbone; la teneur en oxygene de l'h6matine. Bull. boc. chim. biol. Par, 1926, 8: 362-82—Salazar A. L, & Estrada, A. Sur une reaction colloidale nouvelle de 1 hemoglobine. C. rend. Soc. biol, 1932, 109: 488-90.—Schmidt, O Die Einwirkung von Natriumstannit auf den Blutfarbstoff. Deut. Zschr. gerichtl Med, 1932, 19: 516.-Schulz, F. N. Darstellung von mutfarbstoffen In Handb. biol. Arbeitsmeth. (Abderhalden, R.) Berl, 1922 Abt. 1, T. 8, 185-200.-Scotti-Foglieni, L. Influence de 1 hemoglobine k differentes teneurs sur la valeur du coefficient de solubilite du chlorure d'ethyle dans l'eau; le serum et le sang. C. rend. Soc. biol, 1930, 105: 961-4.— Stadie, W. C, & Ross, E. C. Studies on the oxygen-, acid- base and base-combining properties of blood; a rapid method lor the preparation of crystalline isoelectric hemoglobin by the electrodialysis of red blood cells. J. Biol. Chem, 1926, 68: 229-37.—Sula, J. [Chemical changes in prosthetic group of blood pigments] Spisy Lek. Fak. Masaryk. Univ., 1929, 7: 1-8—Szabunewicz, B. [Law of hemoglobin dispersion] Polska gaz. lek, 1929, 8: 82-4.—Tadokoro, T, Abe, M, & Yoshimura, K. On the physico-chemical differences between *-, P- and 7-hemo»lobms. J. Biochem, Tokyo, 1931-32, 14: J45-6L—Timar, E. Ueber den Schwefelgehalt des Hamo- globins im Blute rassenreiner Hundo und einiger seltener unter- suchten Tierarten. Biochem. Zschr, 1928, 202: 305-79 — Valer, J. Ueber den verschiedenen Schwefelgehalt der Hamo- globine verschiedenen Ursprungs. Ibid, 1927, 190: 444-55.— Vickery, H. B, & Leavenworth, C. S. The basic amino acids of horse hemoglobin. J. Biol. Chem, 1928, 79: 377-88.— Vickery, H. B, & White, A. Proportion of cystine yielded by hemoglobins of the horse, dog, and sheep. Proc. Soc. Exp. Biol, N. Y, 1933, 31: 6.—Waelsch, H. Ueber die Hydrolyse von Blutfarbstoff durch Laugenwirkung. Zschr. physiol. Chem, 1927, 168: 188-95.—Wu, H, & Yang, E. F. Molecular weights of natural and denatured hemoglobins and globin. Chin. J. Physiol, 1933, 7: 51-8.—Zeynek, R. Ueber die Ein- wirkung von Pvridin und Zyanwasserstoff auf Blutfarbstoff. Med. Klin, Berl, 1925, 21: 1201. ---- Composition. Friedli, H. *Absorption des rayons ultra- violets par les derives de I'hemoglobine; contribu- tion a l'etude de la constitution chimique des matieres colorant'es du sang. 27p. 8? [Ziir.] 1924. Also Bull. Soc. chim. biol. Par, 1924, 6: 908-15. Barcroft, J. Le groupement proteique dans I'hemoglobine. Bull. Soc. chim. biol. Par, 1928, 10: 279-82.—Haurowitz, F. Konstitution und biologische Eigenschaften des Blutfarbstoffes und ssiner Derivate. Klin. Wschr, 1934, 13: 321-3.------& Waelsch, H. Ueber die Bindung zwischen Eiweiss und pros- thetischer Gruppe im Hamoglobin. Zschr. physiol. Chem, 1929, 182: 82-96—Herzog, A. Zur Frage der Zahl der Kohlen- stoffatome der prosthetischen Gruppe dos Blutfarbstoffs. Biochem. Zschr, 1935, 280: 148-55.—Martini, P, & Loewe, G. Spektrophotometrischer Beitrag zur Konstanz des Hiimo- globinmolekuls. Verh. Deut. Ges. inn. Med, 1928, 40. Kongr, 374-6.—Stadie, W. C. Structural chemistry of hemoglobin. In Cyclop. Med. (Piersol-Bortz) Phila, 1939, 2: 611. ---- crystallized. Costa, C. *Crystaes de hemoglobina em medicina legal. 52p. 8? S. Paulo, 1933. Kresiment, M. *Die Darstellung der Haemo- globinkristalle und ihre gerichts-medizinische Bedeutung. 32p. 8? Berl., 1927. Varella Martins, S. *Contribuieao para o estudo dos crystaes de hemoglobina em medicina legal. 40p. 8? S. Paulo, 1929. Amantea, G. Sulla cristallizzazione dell'emoglobina nell'in- testino di alcuni ematofagi. Boll. Soc. biol. sper, 1926, 1: 65-9.—Aszodi, Z. Ueber eine Darstellungsmethode mensch- licher Haemoglobinkristalle und uber deren Schwefel- und Eisengehalt. Sunti Congr. internaz. fisiol, 1932, 14. Congr. 10.—Bernard, A. T. Sur une technique simple permettant d'obtenir des cristaux d'hemoglobine humaine. Sang, Par, 1934, 8: 123-5.—Deutsch, V. Adsorption de proteides; recherches sur I'hemoglobine cristallisee de cheval. C. rend. Acad, sc, 1936, 203: 182-4.—Falco, G. Sulla cristallizzazione della emoglobina colla saponin a e con altri glicosidi. Zacchia, 1925, 4: 249-58, pl.—Goulliart. Sur une forme cristalline qui precede les cristaux de Teichmann dans la recherche de I'hemo- globine. C. rend. Soc. biol, 1939, 132: 108-11.—Guillemet, R., & Gosselin, G. Sur la presence du cuivre dans 1'hemo- globine cristallisee de pore et de cheval. Ibid, 1932, 111: 41__Nicoletti, F. Sul valore della cristallizzazione dell'emo- globina per la diagnosi specifica del sangue. Arch, antrop. crim. Tor 1928 48: 705-21. ------ La cristallizzazione dell'emo- globina nelle varie etk dell'uomo. Ibid, 1930, 50: 386; Suppl. 1 592 —Teitel-Bernard, A. Sur los cristaux incolores d'hemo- globine. C. rend. Soc. biol, 1934, 115: 303.------& Giusca, D. Quelques observations cristallographiquos sur l'hemo- o-l'obine humaine. In Hommage mem. J. Cantacuzene, Par, 1934 721-31.—Umesue, Y. Demonstration der Hiimoglobin- kristalle der Vertebraten und eine neue Methode zu deren Priiparierung. Jap. J. M. Sc, 1940, 8: Proc. Anat, 20.— Vacca, G. Ricerche sulla cristallizzazione della emoglobina. Zacchia, 1926, 5:43-59. HEMOGLOBIN 508 HEMOGLOBIN ---- Cyan-hemoglobin. See Cyanic acid, Poisoning; also Hemoglobin, Met hemoglobin. ---- Decomposition, and denaturation. Kraus, W. *Zur Frage des Blutfarbstoff- abbaues unter bakterieller Einwirkung. 24p. 8? Erlangen, 1934. Anson. M. I,. & Mirsky. A. K. The equilibria between native and denatured lieTnunIot in in »alie\ late solutions and the theo- retical consequences of the equilibrium between native and denatured protein. J. Gen. Physiol, 1934, 17: 399-108.— Baar, II. S, & Hickmans, E. M. Alkali denaturation of oxyhemoglobin, haemoglobin, carbonmonoxydhaemoglobin, methaemoL'lolin and cvanmethaemoglobin. J. Physiol, Lond, 1941, 100: Proc, 3.—Barkan, G. Zur Frage des Blutfaibstoff- zerfalls durch verdiinnte Sauren. Biochem. Zschr, 1930, 224: 53-62.—Bauer, H, & Strauss, E. Zur Kenntnis des Hamo- globins. In Probleme Bakt. (Kolle, W.) Lpz, 1935, 243-8 — Bingold, K. Abspaltungsvorgange am llamoglobinmolekiil un- ter dem Einfluss von Gewebszellen. Deut, Arch. klin. Med, 1926 154: 53-9. ------ Oxvdative Blutzerstorung und HlutfarbstofTschutz. Klin. Wschr, 1928, 7: 1347; Also Miinch. med. Wschr, 1928, 75: 1373-6.------Oxydative Kntfiirbbarkeit des Hiimoglobins nach bakterieller Zerstorung iles Blutfarbstoffschutzkorpers. Klin. Wschr, 1928, 7: 1794. ------ Ueber den Blutfarbstoffabbau; neue chemische und bakteriologische Studien iiber den Mechanismus der Blut- farbstoff zertriimmerung. Ibid, 1929, 8: 806-73.------ Blutfarbstoffvernichtende Bakterim (Studien mit Hilfe wasser- Btoffsupcroxvdhildcnder Bakterien auf schlackenfrei herge- stellten Kochblutplatten) Zbl. Bakt, 1. Abt, 1930-31, 119: 97-100.- Boas. I. Der Abbau des Blutfarbstoffes im Ver- d&uungstrakt dos gesunden Menschen. Arch. Verdauungskr, 1931, 50: 361-6.—Calvo-Criado, V. Untersuchungen Qberden Hamoglobinabbau durch Gewebsextrakte. Biochem. Zschr, 1925, 164: 61-75.—Cole, A. G, & Boor, A. K. Denaturation of hemoglobin. Proc. Soc. Exp. Biol., X. Y, 1929-30, 27: 1056- 9.—Damodaran, M. Vergleichende Studien uber den Abbau von Oxy- und Kohlcnoxydhamoglobin durch Pepsinsalzsiiure Trypsin-Kinase und Erepsin. Fermentforschung, 1929-30, 11: 315-9— Doljanski, L., & Koch, O. Der Blutfarbstoff und die lebende Zeile; iiber den Hamoglobinabbau in Gewcbskul- turen. Virchows Arch, 1933, 291: 379-89.—Fischer, H, & Lindner, F. Leber den Unibau des Blutfarbstoffes durch Hefe. Z-ehr. physiol. Chem, 1926, 153: 54-06.—Franke!, S, Monastcrio, G. Sui prodotti della digestione triptica pro- lungata della emoglobina. Arch. farm, sper, 1929-30, 48: 25-43.—Coldberg, D. On so-called granular degeneration of hemoglobin identified by supravital staining. Bull. biol. med. exp. URSS, 1938, 6: 125-7.—Gralen, N. The splitting of haemoglobin by acids. Biochem. J, Lond, 1939, 33: 1907- 12.—Haurowitz, F. Zur Chemie des Blutfarbstoffes; iiber die uvptische Verdauung des Blutfarbstoffes. Zschr. physiol. Chem, 1930, 188: 161-79. ------Schwerin, P, & Yenson, M. M. Destruction of hemin and hemoglobin by the action of unsaturated fatty acids and oxygen. J. Biol. Chem, 1941, 140: 353-9. Also repr.—Hisey, A. The denaturation of dried hemoglobjn by molecular oxygen, True. Am. Soc. Biol. Chem, 1938, 8: No. 7, 56—Holden, H. F. The denaturation of haemoglobin. Austral. J. Exp. Biol, 1937, 15: 43-8.—Kuroya, M. Ueber die chemischen Beeinflussungen des Blutfarbstoffes durch die Bakterien. Tr. Far East. Ass. Trop. M, 1934, 9: 311-20.—Lewis, P. S. The heat-denaturation of proteins; the free basic acidic groups of fresh denatured haemoglobin. Bio- chem. J., Lond, 1927, 21: 46-53.—Meldrum, N. U. The acid- denaturation of haemoglobin. Ibid, 1931, 25: 1498-5.l2.— Ramsey, H. J. A comparative study of hemoglobin denatura- tion. J. Cellul. Physiol, 1941, 18: 369-77.—Raphael, C. Notes sur la desintegration de I'hemoglobine chez les nephthys. C. rend. Soc. biol, 1934, 116: 212.—Roche, J, & Donnat, L. Stabilite de la combinaison de l'heme ft la globine et denatura- tion des hemoglobines. Ibid, 1939, 131: 401-4.—Sordelli, A, & Ferrari. Etude sur I'hemoglobine des bovides; pouvoir puthogene de Bacillus sp. Ibid, 1930, 105: 718.—Wu, H., & Lin, K. H. Denaturation of hemoglobin. Proc. Soc. Exp. Biol N. Y.. 1926-27, 24: 705-7. ------ Studies on denaturation of proteins; denaturation of hemoglobin. Chin. J. Physiol 1927, 1: 219-34.—Zeynek, R, & Kittel, S. Ueber die Abspal- tung von Eisen aus Blutfarbsroff und Hamatin mittels schwefli- ger Saure als Lichtwirkung. Zschr. physiol Chem, 1934, 224: ---- Derivatives. See also Hematin; Hemopyrrol; Porphyrin, &c. Blomer, A. *Beitrage zur Synthese der Bruchstucke des Blutfarbstoffs. 41n 8° [Miinch.] 1913. Dormaxn, E. *Die Aufspaltung des Blut- farbstoffs (Sauren) iiber Synthesen von Pyrrol- methenen. 61p. 8? Munch., 1916. Keiner, E. *Bcitrage zur Synthese der Bruchstucke des Blutfarbstoffs. 31p. 8? Munch., 1918. Barkan, G. Blutfarbstoff, Eisen, Gallenfarbstoff; ncuore Untersuchungen iiber eisenhaltige Bcrleiter des Hamoglobins. Klin. Wschr, 1937, 16: 1265-8.—Barnard, R. I). The reactions of nitrite with hemoglobin derivatives. J. Mini. Chem, 1937, 120: 177-91. Also repr.-----— & Neitzel, W. Reactions of hydrogen selenide with hemoglobin derivatives. Proc. Soc. Exp. Biol, N. Y, 1938, 39: 162-4. -Cartland, G. F., ,fc Koch, F. G. Studies on the organic precursors of hemoglobin. .1. Biol. Chem, 1928, 78: p. xxii.- Coryell. C. 1)., & Pauline, L A structural interpretation of the acidity of rrxoups associated with the hemes of hemoulobin and hemoglobin derivatives. Ibid, 1940, 132: 769-79. Also repr. Doljanski, I,, & Koch, O. Der Blutfarbstoff und die lebende Zeile; uber : 721-33. ---— Production of hemoglobin as modified l>\ liver abnormalities. Tr. Ass. Am. Physicians, 1931, 46: 281. ---- inactive. Ammundsen, E. [Hemoglobins not binding carbon mon- oxide in normal and pathological states] Nord. med, 1940, 5: 267. ------ Studies on the presence of non-carbon monoxide- combining, inactive, hemoglobin in the blood of normal persons. J. Biol. Chem, 1941, 138: 563-70. Also repr.------& Trier, M. On the blood content of inactive hemoglobin with special consideration of hemoglobin standardization. Acta med. scand, 1939, 101: 451-60. ■ Iron content. Balestrieri, F. Sul contenuto in fcrro delTemoglobina umana separata da globuli a diversa resistenza osmotica. Haema- tologica, Pavia, 1938, 19: 501-74.—Barkan, G. Leicht abspalt- lares Bluteisen und Blutfarbstoff. Klin. Wschr, 1932, 11: 1050.------& Schales. O. Hamoglobin und leicht abspalt- bares Eisen bei der Adsorption und bei der Kataphorese. Zschr. physiol. Chem, 1936, 244: 257-65.—Bingold, K. Uebei Oxydationsvorgiinge an der eisenhaltigen Komponente des Hamoglobins; zugleich ein Beitrag zur Kenntnis oxydie- rendcr Fahigkeiten lebender Bakterienzellen. Klin. Wschr, 1928, 7: 928-31.—Coryell, C. D. The existence of chemical interactions between the hemes in fcrrihemoglobin (methemo- globin) and the role of interactions in the interpretation of lerro-ferrihemoglobin electrode potential measurement-. J. Phys. Chem, 1939, 43: 841-52.—Elvehjem, C. A, A Hart, E. B. The relation of iron and copper to hemoglobin svnthesis in the chick. J. Biol. Chem, 1929, 84: 131-41.—Josephs, H. H, & Winocur, P. Sobre el hallazgo de hierro no hemo- gloliinico en la sangre. Arch, argent, pediat., 19-10, 13: 91.— Kiister, W. Die eiscmhaltige Komponente des Blutfarbstoffes, ihr Nachweis und ihre Dcrivate. In Handb. biol. Arheitsmeth. (Ahder Iralden. E.) Berl, 1922, Abt. 1, Teil 8, 201-22.- Salomon, K. 1 errihemoglobin. Sympos. Quant. Biol, 1939, 7: 301-11 — Schiiler, H. Ueber die Oxydation des Hiimoglobincisens durch Ferricyank:ilium und das Gleichgewicht der Reaktion. Bio- chem. Zschr., 1932, 255: 474-88. ---- Isoelectric point. Li, O. F. *Dcr isoelektrische Punkt von menschlichem Hamoglobin. 16p. 8? Berl.- Charlottenb. [1935] Glass, J., A: Groscurth, G. Die Veriinderung des isoelek- tri.-cheu I'nuhii-s des Hamoglobins und seine Beziehungen zum Saun-Ha-.jnhau.-lia!l. Klin. Wschr, 1932, 11: 1070.—Neppi Modona. G. II puuto isoelettrico delTemoglobina in presenza o in assenza di HCOj -COj in soluzione. Arch. sc. biol, Bologna, 1937, 23: 171-84 Rubowitz, M. Ueber den iso- elektrischen Punkt des Hamoglobins im Hohenklima. Bio- chem. Zschr, 1933, 266: 190-6.—White, H. L, & Monnghan, B. It. The isoelectric point of adsorbed hemoglobin. J. Biol, Chem, 1936, 113: 371-4. Also repr. ---- Magnetic property. Berthier, P. Variations du coefficient d'aimantation speci- fique de Toxyhemoglobine en presence de soude et d'acide chlorhydrique. C. rend. Acad, sc, 1939, 208: 1435-7.— Coryell, C. D, & Pauling, I, The magnetic properties and structure of hemoglobin, oxvhemoglobin and carbonomonoxy- hemoglobin. Proc. Nat. Acad. Sc. U. S, 1936, 22: 210-6. ------& Dodson, R. W. The magnetic properties of inter- mediates in the reactions of hemoglobin. J. Phys. Chem, 1939, 43: 825-39.—Rawlinson, W. A. The variation of the magnetic susceptibibty of haemin in various solvents. Austral. J. Exp. Biol, 1940, 18: 185-92. ---- Metabolism. See also Bile pigment; Pigment, Metabolism; Porphyrin; Reticuloendothelial system. Siegrist, T. *Hamoglobinumsatz und Kno- chenmarkstatigkeit an Hand von Untersuchungen (iber die Hamoglobinsynthese in vitro [Lausanne] 61p. 22'2cm. Bern, 1940. Bingold, K. Zur Mechanik des Blutfarbstoffabbaues. Verh Deut. Ges. inn. Med, 1929, 41. Kongr, 213-5.------Zur Frage nach dem Schicksal des Hamoglobins im Organismus Klin. Wschr, 1934, 13: 1451. ------ Ueber die Bedeutung von Katalase und Hydroperoxyd fur den Blutstoffwechsel; Darstellung eines biologischen Blutfarbstoffabbaues auf Grund von Modellversuchen. Deut. Arch. klin. Med, 1934-35, 177; 230-61. ------ Ueber das Schicksal des uberalterten Blut^ farbstoffes im Organismus. Zschr. ges. exp. Med, 1936, 99: 325-40. ------ Bedeuteame Mecnanismen im Verlauf des Rlutfoibstoffabbau.'s. Klin. Wsehr, 1941, 20: 331-1.— liorcuzzi, <;.. A: Giarclioro, It. Rapporti fra ricambio energetico e rieaiubio emoglnliinieo. Haematologica, Pavia, 1939, 20: 775-88.--Boycott, A. F. The regulation of the haemoglobin in the blood of mammals. Science Progr, Lond, 1936 37, 31- 401-13— Brown, W. L. The life history of Iraem.iglobin clinically considered. S. Barth. Ib>sp. Rep, Lond., 1926. 59: 135-52.—Dordi, A. M, Ac Rossi, G. Sul ricambio emoglobinico nil lattante e nei bambino normale. Riv. clin. pediat, 1936, 43: 594-600, eh.—Duesberg, R. Leber die biologischen Bezie- hungen des Hamoglobins zu Bilirubin und ILimatin bei nor- malen und pathologischen Zustiindeu des Mensclien. Arch exp. Path, Berl, 1933-34, 174: 305-27. Fischer. II. Ueber Blut-und Gallenfarbstoff. lag. Phvsiol, 1«J15, 15: is.5;79l — Giordano, C, & Griva, L. I rapporti fra Telirninnzione del ferro e della bilina nolle orine e nelle feci. Boll. Soc. ital. biol sper, 1928, 3: 1033-5—Govaerts. P, & Cambicr, P. Influence de Tintroduction d'eau dans le duodenum sur la teneur du sang arteriel en hemoglobine. ('. rend. Soc. biol, 1930, 105: 40-2.— Greppi, E. Sul ricambio emoglobinico in condizioni fisiologiche e patologiche. In Atti Fond. sc. Cagnola, Milano (1917-23) 1924, 26: 1-54.— lleilmeyer, L. Blutfarbstoffwechselstudien; Probleme, Methoden und Kritik der Whippleschen Theorie Deut. Arch. klin. Med , 19.'!). 171: 123-53.—Hijmans van den Bcrgh. Abbau des ILiinoglobins. Mitt. Ges. inn. Med. Wien 1931, 30: 05-81. Also Wien. med. Wschr, 1931, 81: 1359-64.— Israels, M. C. G. Haemoglobin metabolism. Lancet, Lond, 1941, 2: 443.—Jones, C. M. Blood pigment metabolism and its relation to liver function. Arch. Int. M, 1922, 29: 013- G8.—Lemberg, R. The disintegration of haemoglobin in the animal body. In Perspectives in Biochem. (Needham, J, & Green, D. E.) Cambr, 1937, 137-49.—Molinari-Tosatti, P. Contributo alio studio comparative delTeliminazione intestinale del ferro e della bilina (ricambio emoglobinico) Policlinico, 1932, 39: sez. med, 209-35.—Monasterio, G. II ricambio delTemoglobinaallumedellepiureee.nli ricerche. Itass.fisiopat, 1490, 12: 129-38.------Come puo essere studiatoil ricambio della emoglobina e del ferro. Ibid, 103-9 -Muller, P. Dor Hamoglobingehalt des normalen Serums. Klin. Wschr, 1932, 11: 1352.—Nizza, M. Ricerche sul ricambio emoglobinico in gravidanza. Ann. ostet. gin, 1933, 55: 119-66.—Nothhaas, It. Zur Frage des physiologischen Blutfarbstoffabbaues. Zschr. klin. Med, 1933, 124: 490; 125: 78. —----& Widenbauer, F. Zur Frage des physiologischen Blutfarbstoffabbaues; Bezie- hungen zwischen Blutfarbstoff und Harnfarbstoff. Zschr. ges. exp. Med, 1934, 93: 644-52.—Rossi, G, & Dordi, A. M. Sul ricambio emoglobinico nei neonato normale. Lattante, 1930, 7: 800-8.—Stearns, G, & McKinlcy, J. B. The conserva- tion of blood iron during the period of physiological hemoglobin destruction in early infancy. J. Nutrit, 1937, 13: 143-56.— Tapella, P. A. Metabolismo del pigmento hematico; las por- firias. Accion med, B. Air, 1940, 10: 241-5.—Torrioli, M. Indagini sul metabolismo emoglobinico mediante la perfusione epatica; ricerche istologiche. Fisiol. & med, Roma, 1931, 2: 442-8, pl.—Volsky, M, & Scheveleva, E. [Methodology of investigation of hemoglobin anabolism] Klin, med, Moskva, 1927, 5: 898-900.—Watson, C. J. The pyrrol pigments, with particular reference to normal and pathologic hemoglobin metabolism. In Handb. Hemat. (Downey, H.) N. Y, 1938, 4: 2447-580.—Wimplinger, F. Weitere Untersuchungen iiber das Vorkommen eines neuen Blutfarbstoffabbauprodu'.ctes (Pent- dyopent) in. Hani. Deut. mod. Wschr, 1935, 61: 1072-4.— Zoja, L. Sul catabolismo della emoglobina. Minerva med. Tor, 1938, 29: 385-7. ---- Metabolism: Pathology. See also Anoxemia; Carbon dioxide, Poisoning; Liver, Disease, &c. Chiale, G. F. Note sul ricambio emoglobinico in derma- tologia e in condizioni sperimentali varie. Gior. ital. derm. sif, 1935, 76: 1249-67.—Dick, M. Concerning the relative response to blood gains and blood losses; and habituation to an excess of blood pigment. J. Exp. M, 1933, 58: 707-29. Also repr.—Engelkes, H. The specific oxygen capacity of the Mood-colouring matter in pathological conditions. Q. J. Med.. Oxf, 1928-29, 22: 507-17.—Fairley, N. H. Methaemal- bumin in man; pseudo-methaemoglobin. Proc. R. Soc. M, Lond, 1938-39, 32: Sect. Ther. Pharm, 1278-80— Fischer, F. P. Ueber die Diffusion von Hamoglobin gegen Kammer- wasser, Glaskorper und Blutserum. Arch. Augenh, 1931-32, 105: 431-42.—Haurowitz, F. Ueber physiologisch und patho- logist auftretende Formen des Hamoglobins und seiner Deri- vate Med. Klin, Berl, 1929, 25: 1894; 19J5— Heilmeyer, L. Blutfarbstoffwechselstudien; Blutmauserung und Leberfunktion beim Morbus Basedow. Deut. Arch. klin. Med, 1931, 171: M5-28.------Hamoglobinstoffwechsel und Hamoglobin- stoffwechselkrankheiten. Zbl. inn. Med, 1934, 55: 817; 850. ——— & Oetzel, W. Blutfarbstoffwechselstudien; Ergebnisse bei Gesunden; Diiitversuche; der Blutfarbstoffwechsel im Hunger. Deut. Arch. klin. Med, 1931, 171: 365-77.—Leo. S. II ricambio emoglobinico nelle emopatie. Haematologica (Arch.) Pavia, 1935, 16: 659-72.—Lintwarew, 1.1. Zur Frage der Bedeutung des Hamoglobins in der Pathologie. Virchows, Arch, 1932, 285: 625-50.—Litarczek, G, & Dinischiotu, G. T. Contribution k l'etude des echanges respiratoires (sur les variations qualitatives de I'hemoglobine en physio-pathologie humaine) Arch, roumain. path.. Par.. 1933. 6: 243-351 3 pl.— HEMOGLOBIN 51 Lwoff, A. Die Bedeutung des Blutfarbstoffes fiir die parasi- tischen Flagellaten. Zbl. Bakt, 1. Abt, 1933-34, 130: 498- 518 —Mircoli, D, & Mosco, D. II ricambio emoglobinico del vecchio. Rass. fisiopat, 1938, 10: 686-703.—Muir, R., & Heggie, J. F. Haemoglobincholia in toxic conditions. J. Path. Bact, Cambr, 1935, 40: 335-44.—Otto, W., &HeiImeyer L. Klinische Farbmessungen; der Einfluss von Phenylhydro zingaben und Aderlassen auf den Blutfarbstoffwechsel mil besonderer Beriicksichtigung der Harnfarbstoffausscheidung Zschr. ges. exp. Med, 1931, 77: 144-72.—Risquez, F. A. F" signo del pigmento hematico. Gac. med. Caracas, 1925, 32 82 —Taylor, A, & Pollack, M. A. Hemoglobin level and tumo growth. Cancer Res, 1942, 2: 223-7.—Vaughan, J. M., c Saifi, M. F. Haemoglobin metabolism in chronic infection? J. Path. Bact, Lond, 1939, 49: 69-82.—Zoja, L. Sul ricambio emoglobinico in condizioni normali e patologiche. Haema- tologica, Pavia, 1930, 1: 25-48. --- Methemoglobin. Graf, E. *Zur Kenntnis der Methaemo- globinbildung. 19p. 8? Basel, 1926. Austin, J. H, & Drabkin, D. L. Spectrophotometry studies; Methemoglobin. J. Biol. Chem, 1935-36, 112: 67-88. Also repr.—Balthazard, V, & Condrea, P. Obtention rapide de methemoglobine pure et stable. Ann. med. leg, 1926, 6: 320-4. .Also C. rend. Soc. biol, 1926, 95: 81-3.—Barnard, R. I), & Neitzel, W. Reaction of fulminate with methemoglobin. Proc. Soc. Exp. Biol, N. Y, 1938-39, 39: 171. Berthier, P. Imbibition des solutions de methemoglobine k travers la cellulose. C. rend. Acad, sc, 1940, 210: 452-4.—Brooks, J. The oxidation of haemoglobin to mcthaemoglobin bv oxygen. Proc. R. Soc, Lond, 1931, ser. B, 109: 35-50.—Cevidalli, A, & Chistoni, A. Existe-t-il une methemoglobine oxycarbonique? Arch. ital. biol, 1906-7, 46: 266-72.—Conant, J. B, & Scott, N. D. The so-called oxygen content of methemoglobin. J. Biol. Chem, 1926, 69: 575-87. ------& Douglass, W. F. An improved method of determining methemoglobin. Ibid, 1928 76: 223-7.—Dene3, A. Ueber die Herstellung von kristallisier- tem Methamoglobin. Bioehem. Zschr, 1930, 223: 481-8.— Fabre, R, & Bazille, S. Sur la methemoglobine fluoree; application de son etude spectrophometrique a la recherche de la methemoglobine et au dosage dis fluorures. J. pharm. chim. Par, 1933, 8. ser, 18: 465-70—Fairley, N. H, & Bromfield, R. J. Pseudo-methaemoglobin. Tr. R. Soc. Trop. M. Hyg, Lond, 1937-38, 31: 374-6.—Gigon, A, & Noverraz, M. Methodes simples d'analyse de la methemoglobine au moyen du stufophotometre de Pulfrich. Schweiz. med. Wschr, 1938, 68: 465.—Halpern, B. N, & Dubost, P. Recherches sur la methe- moglobine. Bull. Soc. chim. biol. Par, 1939, 21: 717-29 — Haurowitz, F. Zur Kenntnis des Methamoglobins und seiner Derivate. Zschr. physiol. Chem, 1924, 138: 68-99.—Have- mann, R, Jung, F., & Issekutz, B. von, jr. Die Bestimmung von Methamoglobin im Blute mit dem lichtelektrischen Kolori- meter. Biochem. Zschr, 1939, 301: 116-24.—Holden, H. F. Methaemoglobin, a spectrophotometric study. Austral. J. Exp. Biol,'1936, 14: 291-304.—Keilin, D., & Hartree, E. F. The combination between methaemoglobin and peroxides: hydrogen peroxide and ethyl hydroperoxide. Proc. R. Soc, Lond, 1935, ser. B, 117: 1-15.—Leers, O. Ueber Photometha- moglobin. Biochem. Zschr, 1908, 12: 252-8.—Levy, M. The preparation and some properties of the crystalline methemo- globin of the horse. J. Biol. Chem, 1930, 89: 173-83. Also repr.—McEIIroy, W. S. Determination of methemoglobin in blood. Ibid, 1920, 41: p. xlvii— Matthes, K, & Gross, F. Ueber den Nachweis von Methamoglobin und Cyanmethamo- globin im strdmenden Blut. Arch. exp. Path, Lpz, 1938-39, 191: 706-14.—Mayer, R. M. Bemerkenswerte Methamo- globineigenschaften. Deut. Zschr. gerichtl. Med, 1935, 25: 112-23.—Michel, H. O. A spectrophotometric method for the determination of methemoglobin in hemoglobin solutions. J. Biol. Chem, 1937, 119: p. Ixix.—Nicloux, M, & Roche, J. Sensibilite compare de la methemoglobine et de Toxyhemo- globine k Taction d'un reducteur. C. rend. Soc. biol, 1925, 93: 1659-62. ------ Sur la teneur en oxyg^ne de la methemo- globine. Bull. Soc. chim. biol. Par, 1926, 8: 71-97.—Oettinger. B. Methemoglobin as a factor of conservative metabolism. J. Am. M. Ass, 1905, 45: 820-30. Also repr.—Roche, J. Sur la methemoglobinisation; Taction de Thydroxylamine sur le pigment sanguin. C. rend. Soc. biol, 1925, 93: 1377.------ & Combette, R. Sur la reversibilite de la denaturation et de la coagulation de la methemoglobine. C. rend. Acad, sc, 1937, 205: 1011-13.—Stadie, W. C. A method for the determination of methemoglobin in blood. J. Biol. Chem, 1920, 41: 237-41. Also repr.— Van Slyke, D. D, & Hiller, A. Gasotnetric deter- mination of methemoglobin. Ibid, 1929, 84: 205-10.—Ville, J., & Derrien, E. Sur une combin.aison fluoree de la methe- moglobine. C. rend. Acad, sc, 1905,~ 140: 1195-7. ------ Sur la methemoglobine et sa combinaison fluoree. Ibid, 1549- 51.—Warburg, O, Kubowwitz, F, & Christian, W. Kohlen- hydratverbrennung durch Methamoglobin (uber den Me- chanismus einer Methylenblaukatalyse) Biochem. Zschr, 1930, 221: 494-7.—Weise, W. Ueber das Pseudo-Methamo- globin (Methaemalbumin) N. H. Fairley's. Deut. tropenmed. Zschr, 1941, 45: 218-24.—Wendel, W. B. Methemoglobin determination; a clinical method. J. Lab. Clin. M., 1938-39, 24: 96-101. HEMOGLOBIN ---- Methemoglobin: Dissociation. ,J^GE.L' G' tG-l *Der Einfluss des Katalysins (1 hionin) auf die Ruckbildung des Methamo- globins in vitro [Leipzig] 16p. 23}£cm. Zeulen- roda, 1937. Cox, W. W., & Wendel, W. B. The normal rate of reversion of methemoglobin to hemoglobin. Proc. Am. Soc Biol Chem, 1941, 35. Meet, 31. Also J. Biol. Chem, 1941, 140: Proc, 31.—Hansen, J. L. [Methylene blue as remedy against methemoglobenemia during chemotherapy with sulfanilamid groups] Ugeskr. laeger, 1940, 102: 352-4.—Hauschild, F. Die Wirkung des Katalysins (Thionin) bei der Methiimoglo- binvergiftung. Arch. exp. Path, Berl, 1936-37, 184: 458-67. ------Zur Ruckbildung des Methamoglobins durch Methy- lenblauund Thionin. Klin. Wschr, 1939, 18: 1580.—Have- mann, R, & Heubner, W. Ueber das Hamoglobin-Methamo- globin-Redoxsystern. Biochem. Zschr, 1938, 299: 222-9 — Heubner, W, & Mobus, H. Methamoglobinbildung und Alkohol. Arch. exp. Path, Lpz, 1938. 190: 223.—Jung, F. Ueber die Ruckbildung des Methamoglobins bei Gegenwart von Alkohol. Ibid, 1939, 192: 464-71.—Rabbeno, A. Sulla tetrocessione in vivo della motemoglohina da bicromato sodico. Boll. Soc. ital. biol. sper, 1936, 11: 33.—Schmidt, O. Unter- suchungen uber das Ilamoglobin-Methamoglobin-Redoxsvstem. Biochem. Zschr, 1938, 296: 210-74.------Erwiderung zu den Bemerkungen von R. Havemann und W. Heubner iiber das Hamoglobm-Mothamoglobin-Redoxsystem. Ibid, 299: 309-76.—Taylor, J. F, & Hastings, A. B. Oxidation-reduction potentials of the methemoglobin-hemoglobin system. J. Biol. Chem, 1939, 131: 049-62. Also repr.—Wendel, W. B. Oxida- tion of lactate by methemoglobin in erythrocytes with regenera- tion of hemoglobin. Proc. Soc. Exp. Biol, N. Y, 1930-31, 28: 401-3.------■ The control of methemoglobinemia with methylene blue. J. Clin. Invest, 1939, 18: 179-85. ---- Methemoglobin: Formation [Methemo- globinemia] See also under Hemoglobinuria; also in 3. ser. Methaemoglobin. Franke, W. *Vermag Methylenblau bczw. Chromosmon im lebenden Organismus Methae- moglobin zu bilden? 35p. 8? [Jena, 1936] Stirner, E. *Zur Wirkung methamoglobin- bildender Substanzcn. 15p. 8? Tiib., 1935. Weber, J. F. [Acute methaemoglobinaemia] 146p. 8? [Kiev, 1910] Balthazard, V, & Philippe, M. La cyanmeth6inoglobine; dosage cyanymetrique de la methemoglobine. Ann. med. leg, 1926, 6: 137-43. Also C. rend. Soc. biol, 1920, 94: 522-4—Bensley, E. H, Rhea, L. J, & Mills, E. S. Familial idiopathic methaemoglobinaemia. Q. J. Med, Oxf, 1938, 7: 325-30.—Bernheim, F, & Michel, H. O. The formation of methemoglobin by various tissues. J. Biol. Chem, 1937, 118: 743-55. Also repr.—Boycott, A. E. Infective mcthaemoglo- biinemia. Brit. M. J, 1911, 2: Suppl, 409. Also J. Hyg, Cambr, 1911, 2: 443-72.—Brooks, J. The oxidation of haemo- globin to methaemoglobin by oxygen; the relation between the rate of oxidation and the partial pressure of oxygen. Proc. R. Soc, Lond, 1935, ser. B, 118: 560-77.—Brooks, M. M. Glucose treatment in methemoglobinemia. California West. M, 1935, 43: 327.------Hemoglobin-methemoglobin and KCN. Proc. Soc. Exp. Biol, N. Y, 1939, 40: 108-12.— Conant, J. B, & Scott, N. D. A spectrophotometric study of certain equilibria involving the oxidation of hemoglobin to methemoglobin. J. Biol. Chem, 1928, 76: 207-22.—Denn- hardt, H. In tragiobulare Methamoglobinamie ohne Hiimo- lyse in der Schwangerschaft. Zschr. Geburtsh. Gyn, 1932-33, 104: 275-92.—Dessemontet, E. Action of essential oils and of some of their constituents upon the formation of methemo- globin in vitro. J. Pharm. Exp. Ther, 1927-28, 31: 377-86.— Dieckmann, W. J. Methemoglobinemia. Arch. Int. M, 1932, 50: 574. Also repr.—Duvoir, M, & Goldberg, R. La methemoglobine et les poisons meth6moglobinisants. Paris med, 1929, 73: 561-6.—Erskine, D. Methaemoglobinaemia in 4 sisters due to furniture-polish (metadinitrobenzene) poisoning. Guy's Hosp. Rep, Lond, 1931, 81: 418-20 — Feuereisen, W, & Klein, O. Ueber den Nachweis der Metha- moglobinamie durch intradermale Histamininjektion. Klin. Wschr, 1932, 11: 1952.—Grober, A. Ueber den Einfluss des Lichtes auf die Bildung von Kohlenoxydmethamoglobin. Arch. exp. Path, Lpz, 1908, 58: 343-9.—Halpern, B. N, & Dubost, P. Relation entre Tequilibre acido-basique du sang et la formation de la methemoglobine. Medecine, Par, 1938, 19: 729-38.—Hamblin, D. O, & Mangelsdorff, A. F. Methe- moglobinemia and its measurement. J. Indust. Hyg, 1938, 20: 523-30.—Harris, J. S. The in vitro formation of an oxidizing agent by surviving tissues and sulfanilamide. J. Clin. Invest, 1939, 18: 521-6.------& Michel, II. O. The formation of methemoglobin and sulfhemoglobin during sulfanilamide therapy. Ibid, 507-19.—Hayhurst, J. S. Methemoglobine- mia- resulting from administration of bismuth subnitrate. CaUfornia West. M, 1936, 44: 401.—Heubner, W. Studien HEMOGLOBIN 512 HEMOGLOBIN Ober Meth&moglobinbildung. Arch. exp. Path, Lpz, 1913, 72: 241-81.------ 2- ser, 20: 373-6. Also Rev rltanhl;; ?""* W*1* 225-33.-Geiger, A. The isolation by uataphoresis of 2 different oxyhemoglobins from the blood of ^esrfmm.als- , Pro^ R^ Soc-' Lond- 1930-31, ser. B, 107: ft^tT^ !P,y^KY Primarer, aliphatischer Aminostick- stoffgehalt des Oxyhemoglobins verschiedener Tierarten. Biochem. Zschr 1935-36, 283: 229-32.-Gorter, E., & Grendel, V tlhe spr(?admg of oxy-hemoglobin. Proc. Akad. wet. Amsterdam, 1926, 29: sect, sc, 371-82. Also Versl. Akad. wet. Amsterdam, 1925, 34: pt 2, 1257-69.—Hill, R, & Holden, H. *. the preparation and some properties of the globin of oxyhaemoglobin. Biochem. J, Lond, 1926, 20: 1326-39 — Hufner, G. Ueber die Dissociation des Oxyhemoglobins in wassenger Losung. Zschr. phys. Chemie, 1893, 11: 794-804. ———- Allerlei Beobachtungen und Betrachtungen iiber das Verhalten des Oxyhemoglobins Reduktionsmitteln gegenuber. Arch. Physiol., Lpz, 1907, 463-9.—Keve, E. Spektrophoto- metnsche Studien an Oxyhemoglobin. Biochem. Zschr, 1928 201: 439-53.—Kirbach, H. Zur Kenntnis der allmahlichen liydrolyse des Pferdeoxyhamoglobins. Zschr. physiol. Chem, 1900, 50: 129-62—Lavialle, P., & Thonnard, J. Reponse aux critiques de M. Nicloux. C. rend. Soc. biol, 1920, 83: 1126.— Lewis, P. S. The kinetics of protein denaturation; the effect of variation in the hydrogen ion concentration on the velocity of the heat denaturation of oxyhaemoglobin. Biochem. J, Lond, 1926, 20: 965-77.------The influence of neutral salts on the velocity of the heat denaturation of oxyhaemoglobin. Ibid, 984-92.—Marchetti, G. Sulla percentuale di ossigeno mobile della ossiemoglobina in condizioni patologiche. Atti Accad. med. fis. fiorent. (1909) 1910, 103.—Martini, P., & Schuler, B. Spektralphotometrische Blutuntersuchungen; die Verenderung des Oxyhemoglobins unter dem Einfluss ultra- violetter Strahlen. Zschr. ges. exp. Med, 1932, 83: 211.— Neumann, A, & Oppermann, K. Untersuchungen uber die Reduktion des Oxyhemoglobins, Sauerstoffzehrung, am leben- den Gewebe und ihre Abhangigkeit vom jeweiligen Zustand des Organismus. Arbeitsphysiologie, 1935-37, 9: 546-9.—Piettre & Vila. Sur la teneur en oxyg&ie de Toxyhemoglobine de cheval C. rend. Acad, sc, 1907, 144: 1370-2.—Piettre, M. Conditions de preparation, aux basses temperatures, de Toxyhemoglobine cristallisee. Ibid, 1939, 208: 307-10. ------ Action aux basses temperatures de l'eau et de quelques electrolytes sur Toxyhemoglobine cristallisee. Ibid, 1759-62.------Action des electrolytes forts sur Toxyhemoglobine cristallisee. Ibid, 1940, 211: 608-11.— Ray, G. B., & Blair, H. A. The effect of varying concentrations of oxyhemoglobin on its light absorption. J. Biol. Chem, 1935, 111: 371-8. Also repr.—Rosa, L. Ueber eine neue Methodik und klinisch diagnostische Verwendungs- moglichkeit der Bestimmung der Blutoxyhemoglobinreduktion im lebenden Menschen. Schweiz. med. Wschr, 1940, 70: 328.—Severin, S, Georgievsky, E, & Tunin, V. The influence of different COs-tensions and temperatures upon the dissocia- tion-curves of blood-oxyhemoglobin. Bull. biol. med. exp. URSS, 1936, 1: 137.—Spitzer„-R. Der kritische Dissoziations- druck des gelosten und des ungelosten Oxyhemoglobins. Klin. Wschr, 1937, 16: 1323.— Sziklay, J. Ueber die Sauerstoff- bindungsfehigkeit des Pferdeoxyhemoglobins bei wiederholtem Umkristallisieren. Biochem. Zschr, 1930, 223: 373-8 — Szreter, I. Oxydation de Toxyhemoglobine. C. rend. Acad, sc, 1907, 145: 203-5—Terroux, K. G. The isoelectric point of sheep oxyhemoglobin determined by titration curves with the glass electrode. J. Physiol, Lond, 1931, 71: 323-30.— Wu, H. Effect of acid and alcohol on oxyhemoglobin with special reference to amount of oxygen evolved. Chin. J. Physiol, 1932, 6: 13-22.—Wyman, J, jr. An analysis of the titration data of oxyhemoglobin of the horse by a thermal method. J. Biol. Chem, 1939, 127: 1-13. Also repr. ---- Physical properties. Austin, J. H, Sunderman, F. W., & Camack, J. G. The osmotic pressure of hemoglobin and of base bound by hemo- globin. J. Biol. Chem, 1926, 70: 427-36.—Barkan, G. Ueber das optische Verhalten von Oa-Hemoglobin- und CO-Hamo- globin-Blutlosungen nach Saurezusatz. Biochem. Zschr, 1935-36, 283: 241-52. Also Proc. Internat. Physiol. Congr. (1935) 1938, 15. Congr, 250.—Camis, M. Osservazioni ultra- microscopiche sull'emoglobina. Bol. Soc. ital. biol. sper, 1926, 1: 538-40. Also Haematologica, Nap, 1927, 8: 155-76, pl — Clark, G. L, & Shenk, J. H. X-ray diffraction studies of globular proteins; hemoglobins. Radiology, 1937, 28: 144- 56.—Duce, W. Sulla tensione superficiale statica in relazione a quella dinamica di soluzioni di emoglobina. Boll. Soc. ital. biol. sper, 1937, 795.—Holden, H. F., & Hicks, C. S. The absorption of ultra-violet radiation by haemoglobin and some of its derivatives. Austral. J. Exp. Biol, 1932, 10: 219-23 — Kdgel, G. Ueber den photochemischen Abbau des Hamo- globins und die Reaktionsbeziehungen zum Chlorophyll. Strahlentherapie, 1931, 42: 379-83.—Ries, J. von. Grunlicht- bestrahlung und roter Blutfarbstoff. Schweiz. med. Wschr, 1937, 67: 596-8.—Schonberger, S. Ueber die Lichtbrechung der Hamoglobine verschiedener Tierarten. Biochem. Zschr, 1933 267:57-63.—Simonovits, S. Ueber die optische A ktivitat des Hemoglobins. Ibid, 1931, 233: 449-59. ------& Balassa, G. Weitere Untersuchungen iiber die optische Aktivitat .des Hamoglobins und einiger Hamoglobinderivate mit besonderer Berucksichtigung ihres Schwefelgehalts. Ibid, 1935, 281: 186-97.—Stadie, W. C, & Sunderman, F. W. The osmotic HEMOGLOBIN 514 HEMOGLOBIN coefficient of sodium in sodium hemoglobinate and of sodium chloride in hemoglobin solution. J. Biol. Chem, 1931, 91: 227-41. ---- Physiology. See also Respiration. Anson, M. L, & Mirsky, A. E. Hemoglobin, the heme pig- ments, and cellular respiration. Physiol. Rev, 1930, 10: 506- 46.— Antogneti, L. L'emoglobina nei sistema chimico regola- tore delle reazione del sangue. Arch. stud, fisiopat. ricambio, 1937, 5: 30.").—Barcroft, J. L'hemoglobine et son role biologi- que. C. rend. Soc. biol, 1928, 99: No. 25. Suppl, 3-28. Also Naturwissenschaften, 1929, 17: 261-9- Kwer, R. F. On the function of haemoglobin in Chironomus. J. Exp. Biol, Lond, 1941-42, 18: 197-205.—Fabre, R, & Laudat, M. Les con- stituants chimiques du sang; hemoglobine et ses derives. In Traite physiol. norm. path. (Roger & Binet) 2. ed. Par. 1934, 7: 61; 145.—Greulich, W. W, Day, H. G. [et al.] Hemoglobin and erythrocytes. Monogr. Soc. Res. Child Develo2, 1938, 3: No. 2, 89-99.—Henderson, Y, & Greenberg, L. A. Hemo- globin and the alkali of the blood. Am. J. Physiol, 1937, 119: 332.—Juga, V. Les mecanismes seer etoii es dans les trophocytes des larves des chironomides k hemoglobine. Arch, roumain. path. Par, 1932, 5: 579-642, 7 pl.- McCutcheon, F. H. Hemoglobin function during the life history of the bullfrog. J. Cellul. Physiol, 1936, 8: 63-81.—Muller, F. Ueber die Einwirkung der weissen Blutkorperchen, der Milz- und Leber- zellen auf den Blutfarbstoff. Munch, med. Wschr, 1923, 70: 865. ---- Solubility. Dill, D. B, Forbes, W. H, & Henderson, L. J. Errors in calculated pH in hemoglobin solutions with little available base. J. Biol. Chem, 1935, 109: 27.—Duce, W. Recherches sur des solutions d'hemoglouine obtenues par dialyse et conservees pendant longtemps. Arch. ital. biol., 1034-35, 93: 64-78. Also Boll. Soc. ital. biol. sper, 1935, 10: 37(1; 37',).—Green, A. A. Studies in the physical chemistry of the proteins; the solubility of hemoglobin in concentrated salt solutions; a studv of the salting out of proteins. J. Biol. Chem, 1931, 93: 495-516. ------ The solubility of hemoglobin in solutions of chlorides and sulfates of vuryiim concent ration. Ibid, 1932, 95: 47-66. ----— Cohn, E. J, 5; 3i78_8^rI*,h6r#I C" Su? 1,em-Ploi des reseaux de diffraction dans 1 etude photographique du spectre d'absorption de Toxyhemoglobine. C. rend. Soc. biol, 1913, 75: 23-5. Doumer. E, & Fourrier, L. Representation spectrale dc Themoiihihirie oxycarhonee. Ibid, 1925, 93: 1366-8.— Drabkin, I). L. A preliminary analysis of the spectra of some hemoglobin derivatives. Proc. Soc. Exp. Biol, N. Y, 1931-35, 32: 456.------A new graphic-mathematical analysis of absorption spectra, as applied to hemoglobin derivatives. J Biol. Chem, 1937, 119: p. xxvi. —— & Austin, J. lb Spectrophotometric studies of hemoglobin derivatives. Proc. Am. Soc. Biol. Chem, 1933, 8: p. xxxvi-xxxviii. — Hall, K. II. A spectroscopic method for the study of haemoglobin in dilute solutions. J. Physiol, Lond, 1934, SO: 502-7.----A spectro-comparator for the studv of hemoglobin. J. Elisha Mitchell Sc. Soc, 1935-36, 51: 289-92, pl.— Kennedy, R. P. A spectrophotometric study of blood solutions. Am. J Phvsiol 1926-27, 79: 346-61.—Klein, D. E, Hall, J. I,, & King, II. h] Spectrophotometric characteristics of hemoglobins; hemo'dnhin of fowls. J. Biol. Chem, 1934, 105: 753 till. Also repr.— Kobayashi. S. The spectral properties of haemoglobin in the molluscs, Area inflata (Reeve) and Area subcronata (Lischke) Tohoku Univ. Sc. Rep, 1935. 10: 257-67.------The spectral properties of haemoglobin in the earthworms. Phere- tima communissima (Goto et Hatai) and Pheretima hilgendorfi (Michaelsen) Ibid, 733-51.—Litarczek, G, A- Dinischiotu, G. T. Glutathion et modifications du spectre de I'hemoglobine C. rend. Soc. biol, 1933, 112: 1014-7. ------& Cosmulesco! I. Sur l'influence des constituants du glutathion sur une cer- taine propriete spectrale de I'hemoglobine. Ibid, 1934, 115: 678-80.—Robinson, E. J. An anomaly in the hemoglobin absorption spectrum produced by suspensions of red cells. Am. J. Physiol, 1941, 133: 428.—Schumm, O. Spektrogra- phische Methoden zur Bestimmung des Hemoglobins und verwandter Farbstoffe. In Handb. biol. Arbeitsmeth. (Abder- halden, E.) Berl, 1924, Abt. 4, T. 3, 63-120.—Sebesta, V., & Herzog, A. Ueber die Lichtabsorption von Oxy- und Kohlen- oxydhamoglobin in neutraler Losung. Biochem. Zschr, 1033, 267: 157-00.—Shenk, J. H, Hall, J. L, & King, H. H. Spectro- photometric characteristics of hemoglobins; beef blood and muscle hemoglobins. J. Biol. Chem, 1934, 105: 741-52, pl. Also repr.—Wachholz, L, Baranowski, W, & Kaczynski, H. Spektroskopische Studien iiber einige Hamoglobinderivate. Bull, internat. Acad, polon. sc, 1934, cl. med, 145-69, 6 pl. Also Deut. Zschr. gerichtl. Med, 1934, 23: 83-8.—Zilzer, V. Spektrophotometrische Studien an Blutfarbstoff und Derivaten. Biochem. Zschr, 1926, 179: 348-63. ---- Sulf-hemoglobin. Durr, L. *Die Lage des Violettstreifens beim Sulfhaemoglobin [Heidelberg] lOp. 8? Rhein- gonheim, 1937. Dalla Volta, A. Nuovi aspetti del proWema delle solfo- combinazioni emoglobiniche. Arch, antrop. crim. Tor, 1926, 46: 383-94. ----■—■ Une nouvelle combinaison hemosulf- hydrique. Arch. ital. biol, 1926, 77: 110-5, pl. Also Bol. Soc. ital. biol. sper, 1926, 1: 579-84.— Desgrez, A, Bierry, H, & Lescoeur, L. Sur la fixation de Thydrogene sulfure dans le sang. C. rend. Acad, sc, 1926, 182: 1112-6.—Drabkin, D. I., & Austin, J. H. Spectrophotometric studies; preparations from washed blood cells; nitric oxide hemoglobin and sullhemoglo- bin. J. Pool. Chem, 1935-36, 112: 51-65. Also repr — Haurowitz, F. Ueber das Sulfhamoglobin (nebst Nachtragen zu den fruheren Mitteilungen) Zschr. physiol. Chem, 1926, 151: 130-44. ------ The prosthetic group of sulfhemoglohin. J. Biol. Chem, 1941, 137: 771-81.—Hubbard, R. S, & Rose, W. J. Note on the spectroscopic test for sulphemoglobin. Am. J. Clin. Path, 1931, 1: 463-6—Jung, F. Ueber das sogenannte Sulfhamoglobin. Arch. exp. Path, Berl, 1939^0, f„?4,: 16-30—Michel, H. O. A study of sulfhemoglobin. J. Biol. Chem, 1938, 126: 323-48. ---- Sulf-hemoglobin: Pathology. See also Cyanosis. Archer, H. E, & Discombe, G. Sulphaemoglobinaemia, its cause and prevention, with special reference to treatment with sulphanilamide. Lancet, Lond, 1937, 2: 432-5.—Giordano, C, & Vigliani, E. Un caso di solfoemoglobinemia. Gior. Accad.med. Tor., 1935,98:182-7. ----— Solfoemoglobinemia. Arch. sc. med. Tor, 1937, 64: 137-220.—Hartogh, J. de [A case of sulphemoglobinemia] Ned. tschr. geneesk, 1926, 70: l^l-i-o.—Healy, J. C. Sulphemoglobinemia. J. Lab. Clin. M, 1933, 18: 348-54.—Hijmans van den Rergh, A. A. Con- cerning sulphaemoglobinaemia. Proc. Akad. wet. Amsterdam 1922, 24: sect, sc, 1392-8.—Long, W. C, & Spriggs, E. I. On sulphsemoglobinaemia. In Duff House Papers (Spriggs) Lond, 1923, 1: 359-67.—Mackenzie, G. M. Sulphemoglo- binemia. In Clin. Misc. Bassett Hosp, 1934, 1: 129-35.— Nor'on- I>- M. Sulphemoglobinemia. Proc. Mayo Clin, U27, 2: 190-2.—Schoonhoven van Beurden, A. J. R. E. van [Care of sulphemoglobinemia] Ned. tschr. geneesk., 1931, 75: pt 4, o720.—Vogel, K. Sulphemoglobinemia; with report of a case having a definite etiology. Am. J. M. Sc, 1924, 168: u-7: —----& Famulener, L. W. A case of sulphemoglo- binemia Proc. N. York Path. Soc, 1922, 22: 163-6.—Wendel, ^•TP: kul'hemoglobiiiemia. In Modern Med. Ther. (Barr, D. P.) Bait, 1940, 3: 3021. HEMOGLOBIN 515 HEMOGLOBINOMETRY --- Therapeutic use. See also Anemia, Treatment: Hemoglobin. Dhirendra Nath Banerjee. lntersuchun- gen iiber die Pigmentbildung aus reinem Hamo- globin und aus Blut, 24p. 8° Berl., 1926. GittEr, A. *Der Einfluss parenteraler Gaben von Hamoglobin und Hamoglobinabbauproduk- ten auf den Blutfarbstoffwechsel mit besonderer Berucksichtigung der Harnfarbstoffausscheidung [Jena] p.594-630. 8? Berl., 1931. Also Zschr. ges. exp. Med, 1931, 77: Aubertin, E, Lacoste, A, & Castagnou, R. Sur le pouvoir toxique de I'hemoglobine administree par voie veineuse chez le chien. C. rend. Soc. biol, 1939, 132: 129-31. Also J. med. Bordeaux, 1939, 116: 570. ------ Teneur en fer des divers organes chez des chiens ayant subi une injection d'hemoglobine dans les veines. C. rend. Soc. biol, 1939, 132: 139-41. Also J. med. Bordeaux, 1939, 116: 572. ------ Etude comparative des gaz du sang chez des chiens en etat d'anemie aigue par saignee, traites ou non ulterieurement par une injection intra- veineuse, k dose therapeutique, d'une solution d'homo- ou d'heterohemoglobine, de sang de chien ou de -serum physio- logique. Ibid, 572.—Aubertin, E, Wangermez, C, & Sappey, F. Influence de la pression colloidale osmotique des solutions d'hemoglobine heterogdne sur leur toxicite ou leur innocuite, en injection intraveineuse chez le chien. C. rend. Soc. biol, 1936, 121: 236-8.—Broussy, J. Cortico-surrenale et injections d'hemoglobine. Ibid, 1933, 113: 1470. Also Arch. Soc. sc. med. biol. Montpellier, 1934, 15: 179-81.—Drabkin, D. L, Widerman, A. H, & Landow, H. The fate of hemoglobin injected into the blood stream. J. Biol. Chem, 1935, 109: p. xxvii.—Granel, F. Recherches histologiques sur les modi- fications de I'hemoglobine injectee dans l'organisme. Arch. anat. micr. Par, 1929, 25: Spec. no. 104-20.—Newman, W. V, & Whipple, G. H. Hemoglobin injections and conservation of pigment by kidney, liver and spleen; the influence of diet and bleeding. J. Exp. M, 1932, 55: 637-52, pl. Also repr.— O'Shaughnessy, L, Mansell, H. E, & Slome, D. Haemoglobin solution as a blood substitute. Lancet, Lond, 1939, 2: 1068. --- Tolerance test. See Hemoglobinuria, Renal threshold. --- in animals. Soldner, I. [K. K. M. L.] *Vergleichende Hamoglobinbestimmungen an Blut verschiedener Haustiere [Munchen] 33p. 20}£cm. Heidelb., 1937. Barcroft, J. The significance of hemoglobin in submam- malian forms of life. Physiol. Rev, 1925, 5: 596-617.— Cook, S. F, & Harmon, I. W. The regulation of the hemo- globin level in poultry. Am. J. Physiol, 1933, 105: 407-17.— Dalla Volta, A, & Viterbi, E. Recherches spectrographiques sur les chlorohemoglobines obtenues du sang de quelques especes d'animaux. Arch. ital. biol, 1928, 79: 15-8, 2 pl.— Dolk, H. E, & Paauw, F. van der. Die Leistungen des Hemo- globins beim Regenwurm. Zschr. vergl. Physiol, 1929, 10: 324-43.—Raphael, C. Sur la localisation de I'hemoglobine et de ses derives chez quelques aphroditiens. C. rend. Acad. sc, 1936, 202: 588-90.—Salomon, K. Studies on inverte brate hemoglobins. J. Biol. Chem, 1940, 133: Proc, 83 — Simonovits, S, & Balassa, G. Ueber die optische Aktivitat des Globinhamochromogens und des in n/4 Natronlauge gelosten Hamoglobins (Globin-Hematin) vom Pferde, mit besonderer Berucksichtigung ihres Schwefelgehalts. Biochem. Zschr, 1935, 281: 333-8.—Steinhardt, J. Total dissociation of horse haemoglobin. Nature, Lond, 1936, 138: 800.— Wyman, J., jr, & Ingalls, E. N. Interrelationships in the reac- tions of horse hemoglobin. J. Biol. Chem, 1941, 139: 877-95. Also repr. HEMOGLOBINEMIA. See Hemoglobinuria; Hemolysis. HEMOGLOBINOMETRY. See also Erythrocyte, Hemoglobin. Wagner, A. *Contribution k l'etude compara- tive des methodes de dosage de I'hemoglobine et du fer sanguin [Strasbourg] 148p. 24cm. Saint-Die, 1938. Ashford, C. A. Estimation of haemoglobin. Brit. M. J, 1942, 1: 163.—Barkan, G. Hemoglobin estimation with undiluted reduced blood. J. Lab. Clin. M, 1940-41, 26: 1823-8.—Barrett, J. F. A new blood test and its application to the microdetermination of haemoglobin. Brit. J. Exp. Path, 1940, 21: 22-5.—Baumberger, J. P. The accurate determination of hemoglobin, oxyhemoglobin and carbon monoxide hemoglobin (or myohemoglobin) by means of the dropping mercury electrode. Am. J. Physiol, 1940, 129: 308. Campbell, R. D. Haemoglobinometry. Brit. M. J , 1941 2: 747; 1942, 1: 88.—Dick, G. F., & Stevens, D. S. A photoelectric hemoglobinometer. J. Am. M. Ass, 1940, 114: 1065. Also repr.—Drabkin, D. L, & Austin, J. H. A technique for the analysis of undiluted blood and concentrated hemoglobin solutions. J. Biol. Chem, 1935-36. 112: 105-15 — Evelyn, K. A, & Malloy, H. T. Microdetermination of oxv- nemoglobin, methemoglobin, and sulfhemoglobin in a single sample of blood. Ibid, 1938, 126: 655-62.—Ewing, M. E, & Blatherwick, N. R. A method of collecting and transporting small blood samples for hemoglobin determination. J. Lab. Clin. M, 1940-41, 26: 395-8.— Hill, D. K, & Pincock, A. C. Photoelectric method of estimating haemoglobin. Lancet, Lond, 1941, 2: 754.—Hoffman, W. S. The determination of hemoglobin. In his Phot. Clin. Chem, N. Y, 1941, 48-62.— Karr, W. G, & Clark, J. H. Comparison of various hemo- globin methods as performed in hospital and physicians' laboratories. Am. J. Clin. Path, 1941, 5: Techn. Suppl, 127-47.—Kramer, K. Bestimmung des Sauerstoffgehaltes und der Hamoglobinkonzentration in Hamoglobinlosungen und hemolysiertem Blut auf lichtelektrischem Wege. Klin. Wschr, 1933, 12: 1875. Also Zschr. Biol, 1934, 95: 126-34.—McLain, P. L, & Pastorius, G. J. Observations with a photoelectric hemoglobinometer. J. Lab. Clin. M, 1940-41, 26: 1054-7.— Maxfield, M. E., Bazett, H. C. [et al.] A differential photo- electric colorimeter for determination of hemoglobin concentra- tion and of small percentages of carbon monoxide hemoglobin. Am. J. Physiol, 1940, 129: 420.—Mills, A. J. E. Haemoglo- binometry. Brit. M. J, 1941, 2: 823.—Parpart, A. K, Amber- son, W. R, & Stewart, D. R. The determination of hemoglobin concentration in dilute solutions. Biol. Bull, 1931, 61: 518- 24.—Plesch, J. Haemoglobinometry. Brit. M. J, 1941, 2: 859.—Rimington, C. Haemoglobinometry. Ibid, 1942, 1: 177.—Smith, W. Haemoglobinometry. Ibid, 1941, 2: 926.— S0rensen, G. Variations in the haemoglobin content of capillary blood and their significance in the technique of haemoglobin estimation. Nutrit. Abstr, Aberdeen, 1941-42, 11: 185.—Szigeti, B. Estimation of oxyhaemoglobin and of methaemoglobin by a photoelectric method. Biochem. J, Lond, 1940, 34: 1460-3.—Van Slyke, D. D, & Hiller, A. Gasometric control of standard solutions for the Palmer hemoglobin method. J. Biol. Chem, 1929, 84: 211-6.— Walters, A. H. Haemoglobinometry. Brit. M. J, 1942, 1: 201.—Weinbach, A. Untersuchungen von Hamoglobinver- bindungen mit Hilfe der Infrarotphotographie. Zschr. ges. exp. Med, 1937, 101: 477-83.—Wolvius, R. J. [Objective determination of blood pigments] Ned. tschr. geneesk, 1924, 68: 237-45. HEMOGLOBINURIA. See also Hematuria; Hemochromatosis; Hemo- lysis; Porphyria; also Erythrocyte, Resistance: Variation. Rothhaar, H. *Veranderungen des Hamo- globins im Urin. 23p. 8°. Jena, 1935. Amy, A. C. Haemoglobinuria: a new problem on the Indian frontier. J. R. Army M. Corps, 1934, 62: 178; passim.— Beaumont, G. E. Haemoglobinuria. In Brit. Encycl. M. Pract. (Rolleston, H.) Lond, 1937, 6: 115-22.—Brennan, C. H. A note on a case of haemoglobinuria in a Ukamba native. East Afr. M. J, 1934, 11: 226.—Collignon, M. Les hemoglo- binuries. Arch. med. pharm. mil, 1929, 90: 615-41.—Darm- staedter, E. Ein Beitrag zur Erforschungsgeschichte der Hemoglobinamie und Hamoglobinurie Sudhoff Arch, 1935-36, 28: 338-46.—Falkiewicz, A, & Musial, W. [Clinical aspect of hemoglobinuria] Polskie arch. med. wewn, 1935, 13: 253-77.—Gertzenberg, G. I. [Hemoglobinuria] Vest, khir, 1929, 18: 168-71.—H. Hemoglobinuria. In Cyclop. Med. (Piersol-Bortz) Phila, 1939, 7: 213-5.—Hsii, K. L. Two cases of hemoglobinuria. Annual Rep. Canton Hosp, 1934-35 24-6.--Hymans van den Bergh, A. A. Les hemoglobinuries. Strasbourg med, 1926, 84: 362-9.—Jordan, F. L. J. [Hemo- globinuria] Ned. tschr. geneesk, 1937, 81: 2024-6.—Kiister, W, & Grosse, A. Ueber einen Fall von Hamoglobinurie. Zschr. physiol. Chem, 1927, 168: 174-6.—Liebermann, E, & Maisel, M. [Two cases of hemoglobinuria] Russ. klin, 1929, 12: 268-75.—Stephens, J. W. W. The haemoglobinurias. Tr. R. Soc. Trop. M. Hyg, Lond, 1926-27, 20: 401-21.—To- rrealba, J.F. Algo acerca de hemoglobinuria en Zaraza. Gac. med. Caracas, 1937, 44: 311.—Weil, P. E, & Stieffel. Re- cherches cUniques sur Themoglobinurie. Bull. Soc. med. hop. Paris, 1926, 3. ser, 50: 587-96.—Yuile, C. L. Hemo- globinuria. Physiol. Rev, 1942, 22: 19-31. ---- bilious febrile. See Malaria, Blackwater fever. ---- bovine. See also Babesiasis; Piroplasmosis; Theileri- asis. Babes, V. Etiologie de Themoglobinurie bactenenne du boeuf. Ann. Inst. path. bact. Bucarest (1888-89) 1889, 1: 203-28, pl.—Cocu, J. Rutilance anormale du sang veineux au HEMOGLOBINURIA ;) 16 HEMOGLOBINURIA debut d'un acces d'hemoglohinurie. Bull. Acad. vet. France, 1931, 4: 414-6. ------ Essais dc traitement do Themo- globinurie par la methode du veterinaire Brunscnwick (injection de sang bovin) Ibid, 1933, 6: 357-62.— Cordier, G, & Mana- ger, J. 1'ievre bileuse hemoglobinirrique des bovides en Tunisie. Rec. med. vet. exot, 1937, 10: 61-71.—Erhcbungen iiber die Verbreitung der Hamoglobinurie des Rindes. Blutharnen, im Reich. Reichsgesundhbl, 1938. 13: 329. Folse. C. D. Bovine hemoglobinuria. Vet. Med, Chic, 1941, 36: 570.—Ivanfi, E. [Treatment of hemoglobinuria infectiosa of cattle with acaprin] Allatorv. lap.. I'.WS. 61: 262.- Kuhn, M. J. La hemoglobinuria de los bovinosi. Rev. Inst bact. Dep. nac. hig, B. Air, 193 1, 6: 228-38.— Moussu. Contribution k l'etude de Themoglobinurie bovine observee en France. Bull. Soc. centr. med. vet, 1940, 58: 414-6 Suarez, E, & Prado Le Fort. M. La hemoglo- binuria de los bovinos en Chile. Rev. Inst. bact. Chile, 1931, 2: No. 4, 1-17.—Sordelli, A, & Prado, M. Estudios sobre la hemoglobinuria de los bovinos. Ibid, 1 '.'30, 1: No. 4, 8-10. -----& Ferrari, J. J. L'hemoglobinurie des bovides. C. rend. Soc. biol, 1930, 105: 312-4.------Etudes sur Themoglo- binurie des bovides; Themotoxine secretee par Bacillus sp. Ibid, 719-21. ------ Etudes sur Themoglobinurie des bovides; complexite de la flore anaerobie de la lesion hepatique. Ibid, 1931, 106: 142-4.—Vawter, L. R, & Records, E. Im- munization of cattle against bacillarv hemoclobinuria. J. Am. Vet. M. Ass, 1929, 75: 201-14.—Yakimoff, W. L. Les agents etiologiques de Themoglobinurie des bovides en Russie. Reun. Soc. argent, pat. region. (1929) 1930, 5. Meet, 2: 999-1004. ---- bovine, puerperal. Hjarre, A. Die puerperale Hamoglobinamie des Rindes, eine pathologisch-anatomische Studie besonders mit Rucksicht auf die Pathogenese der bei der Krankheit auftretenden Leberverande- rungen. 150p.; 29p. 8? Kbh., 1930. Forms Suppl. 7, Acta path, microb. scand. Beijers, J. A. Puerperal haemoglobinuria in cattle. Vet. Bull, Lond, 1941, 11: 881 (Abstr.)— Madsen, D. E, & Nielsen, H. M. Parturient hemoglobinemia of dairy cows. J. Am. Vet. M. Ass, 19.3'J, 94: 577-80—Sjoberg, K. Der Gehalt des Blutes an Phosphorverbindungen und Cholesterin bei der puerperalen Hamoglobinamie des Rindes. Skand. Arch. Physiol, Berl, 1939, 81: 42-50. ---- cold. See also Syphilis. Nicol [H.] H. *Ueber einen Fall von paroxys- maler Kalte-Hamoglobinurie [Giessen] 31p. 21cm. Gutersloh, 1938. Soullier, J. *Contribution a l'etude de Themoglobinurie paroxistique a frigore. 60p. 8? Par., 1925. Bj0rn-Hansen, H. Ueber die paroxysmale Keltehemoglo- binurie; mit besonderm Hinblick auf die leukozyteren Blut- veranderungen, die Hamolyse und den Blutdruck im Anschluss an experimentelle Abkuhlungsversuche. Acta med. scand, 1936, 88: 129-79.—Bojlen, K. Paroxismal hemoglobinuria in a 5 year old child with congenital syphilis. Acta paediat, Upps, 1935, 17: Suppl. 1, 324 33.—Cattaneo, L. Emoglo- binuria parossistica a frigore. Gior. ital. derm, sif, 1931, 72: 1159-248.—Chilli, A., & Soccorso, T. Ricerche e considerazioni su di un caso di emoglobinuria parossistica a frigore. Fol. med. Nap, 1930, 16: 819-53.—Cicinnati, V. L'anafilassi e l'azione del calcio nella emoglobinuria parossistica a frigore (contributo clinico e sperimentale) Rinasc. med, 1928, 5: 726-30, pl.— D'Alessandro, G. Contributo alia conoscenza delle modifica- zioni sierologiche nella emoglobinuria parossistica a frigore. Riforma med, 1935, 51: 1280-5.—De Nicolo, F. Contributo alia conoscenza delTemoglobinuria parossi-tiea a frijxore nell'in- fanzia. Pediatria (Riv.) 1933. 41: 854-86.—Di Lorenzi, F. Emoglobinuria parossistica a friaore. C.ior. ital. mal esot 1933, 6: 72-8.—Donath, J, & Landsteiner, K. Ueber Kalte hamoglobinurie. Erg. Hyg. Bakt, 1925, 7: 184-228.— Ferrannini, L. Emoglobinuria parossistica a frigore. Minerva med. Tor, 1935, 26: 209-13.—Harris, K. E., Lewis, T, & Vaughan, J. M. Haemoglobinuria and urticaria from cold occurring singly or in combination; observations referring especially to the mechanism of urticaria with some remarks upon Raynaud's disease. Heart, Lond, 1928-29, 14: 305-37, id-—Htiglund, G. Etude sur 2 cas d'hemoglohinurie k frigore Acta med. scand, 1927, 66: 33-60.—Hoff, F, & Kels, R. Ueber paroxysmale Kaltehamoglobinurie. Deut. Arch klin' Med, 1928, 160: 177-95.—Lehner, I., Rajka, O., & Barkan, l! [Hemoglobinuria from cold] Gy6gj'dszat, 1934, 74: 293-5.— Lichtmann, E. Ueber Erfolge mit Lebertherapie bei einem Falle von paroxysmaler Keltehamoglobinurie. Med. KUn, Berl, 1930, 26: 735.—Lotze, H. Paroxysmale Kaltehamoglobinurie und Vitamin C; vorleuBge Mitteilung. Klin. Wschr, 1936, 15:941. ------ Paroxysmale Kaltehamoglobinurie und ihre Beziehung zu Erkaltungskrankheiten; eine theoretische und experimentelle Untersuchung. Erg. inn. Med. Kinderh, 1937, 52: 277-335—Mitacek, S. Influence des bains gazeux d'acide carbonique sur le cours des acces d'hemoglohinurie paroxystique a frigore. Sang, Par, 1932, 6: 153-7.- Montanari. A. Coir siderazioni sopra un caso di emoglobinuria parossistica a frigore. Riv. clin. med, 1927, 28: 565; 587.—Monteiro de Barros, (). Sobre a hemoglobinuria paroxistica a frigore. Rev. med, S Paulo, 1930-31, 15: No. 53, 10-26 Moorman. K. R. Paro- xysmal hemoglobinuria of syphilitic origin. Virginia M Month, 1934, 61: 14-8.—Rar, E. F. [Hemoglobinuria due to cold] Pediatria, Moskva, 1930, 14: 184-94.—Snlen, E. B. Der kausale Zusammenhang zwischen Lues und Kaltohiimoglo- binurie. Acta med. scand, 1925, 62: 521-57. ------ Beitrag zur Kenntnis iiber Verlauf und Prognose der KfiltehamoKlo- binurie. Ibid, 1931, 75: 612-16.------Thermostabiles, nicht komplexes (Auto-) HiimoK sin bei transitorischer Kelte- hamoglobinurie. Ibid, 1935, 86: 570; 1930, Suppl. 78, 870.— Steinbock, L. Latente Kaltohemoglobinurie hoi kongenital luetischen Kindern. Mschr. Kinderh, 1928, 38: 336-43.— Weil, P. E, & Stieffel, R. Essai do classification de Themo- globinurie a frigore. Bull, med. Par, 1928, 42: 471.—Winter- nitz, L. Contributo alia conoscenza delTemoglobinuria paros-. sistica a frigore. Minerva med. Tor, 1930, 21: pt 2, 680-2. ---- Diagnosis. Boas. Ueber die Benzidinreaktion im Harn. Wien. klin. Wschr, 1929, 42: 368.—Borchardt, W., & Tropp, C. Experi- mentelle Beitrage zur Symptomatologie der akuten Blutzer- fallskrankheiten: Schwarz wasserfieber, paroxvsmale Hamo- globinurie usw. Klin. Wschr, 1928. 7: 1136.— Cogliandro, V. Le prove chimiche del sangue per la diagnosi delle ematurie. Gazz. internaz. med. chir, 1931, 39: 101-9.—Del Carpio, I. La dimostrazione di quantity minime di pigmento ematico nelle urine. Rass. med. sarda, 1937, 39: 189-91.—Fontes, G, & Thivolle, L. Determination de l'intensite de l'hematurie et de TKemoglobinurie. C. rend. Soc. biol, 1925, 93: 089.—Forrest, R. H, & Finlayson, J. Note on the spectroscopic examination of the urine in 2 cases of paroxysmal haematuria; case of paroxysmal haematuria by R. W. Forrest, communicated to the Glasgow Medico-Chirurgical Society, February 1879. Glasgow M. J, 1879, 4. ser, 11: 417-24. Also repr.—Inda- cochea Zarauz, V. Reacci6n cromatica para la investigaci6n de sangre en la orina. Cr6n. med, Lima, 1939, 56: 19-23.— Melnick, D, & Cowgill, G. R. A study of hemolysis in vivo by the application of the benzidine micro-colorimetric method to the determination of free hemoglobin in plasma. Am. J. Physiol, 1937, 119: 70-9. ---- effort [or march] Attlee, W. H. W. Haemoglobinuria following exertion. Lancet, Lond, 1937, 1: 1400.—Fisher, A. M., & Bernstein, A. March hemoglobinuria; a case report. Bull. Johns Hopkins Hosp, 1940, 67: 457-61.—Gilligan, D. R, & Blumgart, H. L. March hemoglobinuria; studies of the clinical characteristics, blood metabolism and mechanism; with observations on 3 new cases, and review of literature. Medicine, Bait, 1941, 20: 341-95.—Hoffmann, W. Ueber einen Fall von paroxysmaler Marschhaemoglobinurie und seine Behandlung. Med. Welt, 1937, 11: 1640.—Lang, K, & Braun, A. Untersuchungen iiber einen Fall von paroxysmaler Marschhamoglobinurie und Hamatinurie. Zschr. klin. Med, 1931, 118: 374-82.—Oehme [Marschhamoglobinurie] Deut. med. Wschr, 1927, 53: 46.— Watson, E. M, & Fischer, L. C. Paroxysmal march haemo- globinuria with a report of a case. Am. J. Clin. Path, 1935, 5: 151-8. ---- epidemic [Winckel's disease] Feldman, W. M. A case of so-called Winckel's disease (cyanosis afebrilis icterica cum hsemoglobinuria) Brit. J. Child. Dis, 1927, 24: 113-8.—Stcinhardt, I. Ein Fall von Winckel'scher Krankheit. Arch. Kinderh, 1903-4, 38: 36.— Tada, K. Histological findings of a case of Winckel's disease. Orient. J. Dis. Inf., Kyoto, 1928, 3: 18, 2 pl. ---- equine. Bentzin, O. *Beitrage zur Aetiologie und Therapie der Haemoglobinurie des Pferdea [Leipzig] 8p. 8? Dobeln, 1923. Clauss, K. *Betrachtungen uber die Haemo- globinaemie der Pferde und ihre wehrschaftliche Bedeutung; kommt eventl. eine Haftpflicht de.n Militarfiskus im Manbver in Betracht? [Leipzig] 53p. 8? Freudenstadt, 1925. Dignac, J. L. *De la saignee dans le traite- ment de l'hemoglobinurie paroxystique du cheval [Alfort] 66p. 8? Par., 1928. Drietjx, H. A. D. *Contribution k l'6tude de Themoglobinurie paroxystique a frigore du cheval [Alfort] 41p. 8? Par., 1930. Granmont, L. M. J. *Dehemoglobinuriedu cheval; inconvenients de la saignee [Alfort] 47p. 8? Troyes, 1926. HEMOGLOBINURIA 517 HEMOGLOBINURIA Paradis, M. G. *De l'emploi de l'air et du chlorure de calcium dans le traitement de l'hemo- globinurie du cheval [Alfort] 46p. 8? Chalons- sur-Marne, 1926. Blanchard, L, Medynski, C, & Simonnet, H. Les donnees du problfime de Themoglobinurie paroxystique a frigore du cheval. Bull. Acad. vet. France, 1928, 1: 419-28.------ Les donnees et les inconnues du probleme de Themoglobinurie a frigore du cheval; repartition du glycogenic dans certaines masses musculaires. Ibid, 1992, 2: 100-6.—Bolnat. Hemo- globinurie paroxystique du cheval. Rec. med. vet, 1929, 105: 522-6.—Brion, A. Sur quelques etats hemoglobinuriques du cheval. Ibid, 1932, 108: 593-608.—Brunschwik. Essai de mise au point de traitement de Themiglobinurie paroxystique du cheval par les injections du sang bovin. Ibid, 1934, 110: 727-9.—Cocu, J. Un cas d'hemoglohinurie mortelle observe chez lin cheval maigre. Bull. Soc. centr. med. vet, 1927, 80: 378-80. ------ A propos de Themoglobinurie. Bull. Acad, vet. France, 1930, 3: 230; 1931, 4: 379.—Dement. Quelques faits interessants observes sur des chevaux atteints d'hemo- glohinurie. Ibid, 1933, 6: 54-6.—Detrez. Contribution a l'etude de Themoglobinurie paroxystique du cheval. Rec. med. vet, 1932, 108: 547.—Gerlach, F, & Baumann, R. Unter- suchungen iiber die in manchen Gegenden Oesterreichs gehauft auftretende Hamoglobinamie bei Pferden. Deut. tierarztl. Wschr, 1927, 35: 465-8.—Gucin. Observation sur un cas d'hemoglohinurie paroxystique. Bull. Acad. vet. France, 1931, 4: 387.—Hobmaier, M. Die Hemoglobinurie des Pferdes im Lichte der modernen Allergieforschung. Miinch. tiererztl. Wschr, 1928, 79: 485-90.—Loge & Guilhon. Au sujetdu traite- ment de Themoglobinurie paroxystique du cheval. Bull. Acad. vet. France, 1930, 3: 227-30.—Pelletier & Spitz. Contribution k l'etude de Themoglobinurie chez le cheval. Rev. vet. mil- Par, 1936, 20: 431-3. --- equine, enzootic. Bertrand, I, Blanchard [et al.] La myosite hemoglobinu- rique a frigore du cheval. Rev. neur. Par, 1932, 39: 801-24.— Hederer, P. Zur Therapie der enzootischen Hamoglobinamie. Miinch. tierarztl. Wschr, 1929, 80: 717.—Hobmaier, M. Die sogenannte Haemoglobinuria enzootica des Pferdes und ihr verwandte Krankheiten unserer Haustiere. Arch. wiss. prakt. Tierh, 1926, 54: 213-22.------■ Die sogenannte Haemoglobinaemia enzootica mit Schlundlahmung des Pferdes, eine Futtervergiftung. Miinch. tierarztl. Wschr, 1926, 77: 161; passim. ------ Zur Kenntnis der Haemoglobinuria enzootica und paralytica des Pferdes. Ibid, 669; 719.— Radev, G. L'hemoglobinurie enzootique (atypique) du cheval. Bull. Acad. vet. France, 1938, 11: 101-4.—Scheicher, E. Beobachtungen iiber die sogenannte enzootische Hemo- globinurie mit Schlundlahmung der Pferde. Wien. tierarztl. Mschr, 1926, 13: 73; 121.—Strassl, J. Zur spezifischen Therapie der enzootischen Hamoglobinamie. Miinch. tierarztl. Wschr, 1929, 80: 553. ---- equine, paralytic [Myoglobinuria] Berard, J. *La myoh6moglobinurie insidieuse du cheval [Lyon] 60p. 8? Par., 1935. Carlstrom, B. *Ueber die Aetiologie und Pathogenese der Kreuzlahme des Pferdes: Haemo- globinaemia paralytica [Stockholm] 182p. 8: Berl., 1930. Marchetti, L. *Polymorphisme clinique de la myoglobinurie paroxystique du cheval; maladie de Lucet. 69p. 25K«n. Lyon, 1939. Bechtold, E. Chemische und spektrale Myoglobmnach- weise in pathologischem Pferdeharn durch die Cytochrom- reaktionen. Berl. tierarztl. Wschr, 1935, 51: 565.—Bierling, L. Behandlung der Stallhamoglobinamie der Pferde mit Methylenblau. Ibid, 1926, 42: 410. Also Miinch. tierarztl. Wschr, 1926, 77: 529.—Blaringham. La paresie hemoglo- binurique en ArtoLs (hiver 1933-1934) Bull. Acad. v6t. France, 1934, 7: 262-4 —Brixhe. Sur quelques cas de para- piegie hemoglobinurique. Ibid, 1938, 11: 139.—Brunschwik, M. Quelques recherches sur le sang dans Themoglobinurie paroxystique du cheval. Rec. med. vet, 1934, 110: 592-5. -----Charbonnel, M. [et al.] Quelques observations de paresies hemoglobinuriques. Bull. Acad. vet. France, 1933, 6: 457-68.—Campbell, W. A. Insulin in the treatment of equine myoglobinuria. Vet. Rec, Lond.; 1935, 15: 1547.— Carlstrom, B. Ueber die Aetiologie und Pathogenese der Kreuzlahme des Pferdes (Haemoglobinaemia paralytica) Skand. Arch. Physiol, Berl, 1931, 61: 161; 62: 1; 63: 3 pl — Cocu. Contributions k l'etude de la paresie myohemoglo- binurique. Bull. Acad. vet. France, 1935, 8: 429-35.—Evers. Behandlung der Haemoglobinuria paralytica des Pferdes mit Insulin. Berl. tiererztl. Wschr, 1935, 51: 241—Fedotov, A. I. [Insulin therapy in paralytic hemoglobinemia of horses] Sovet. vet, 1940, 17: No. 6, 36-9.—Florio. La myoglobinurie du cheval: conceptions etio-pathogeniques et sanctions thera- peutiques. Rev. vet. mil. Par, 1939, 23: 117-47.—Fournier, P. Inefficacite de l'insuline dans le traitement de la paresie myohemoglobinurique. Bull. Acad. vet. France, 1936, 9: 54.—Grzycki, S. Ueber das Wesen und die Therapie der Haemoglobinuria paralytica beim Pferde. Berl. tiererztl. Wschr, 1934, 50: 789. ----— La paresie hemoglobinurique du cheval et son traitement par Tinsuline. C. rend. Soc. biol, 1934, 116: 1145-8.—Huth. Zur Therapie der Myoglobinurie des Pferdes. In Was gibt es Neues (Puttkammer, V.) Han- nover, 1938, 182.—Liegois & Verstraete, A. Au sujet de la parapiegie hemoglobinurique du cheval. Bull. Acad. vet. France, 1934, 7: 213-7.—Meshcheriakov, N. [Efficacy of soda solutions in treatment of paralvtic hemoglobinemia in the horse] Sovet. vet, 1940, 17: No. 2, 111.—Mocsy, J. Untersuchungen iiber die Ausscheidung des Myoglobins durch die Nieren. Arch. wiss. prakt. Tierh, 1935, 69: 8-15. ------Ueber das Schicksal des aus den Muskelfasern aus- getretenen Myoglobins. Ibid, 1935-36, 70: 212-26—Neu- mann-KIeinpaul, K, & Horn, H. Behandlung der Myoglo- binurie der Pferde mit Ephedralin-Merck. Berl. tierarztl. Wschr, 1933, 49: 225-7.—Oggero, B. Osservazioni sulle cause predisponenti all'insorgere dell'emoglobinemia paralitica. Gior. med. vet, 1925, 74: 606.—Ries, J. N. Le traitement de Themoglobinemie parapiegique du cheval. Bull. Soc. centr. med. vet, 1900, 54: 228-36.—Severgnini, A. Brevi considera- zioni su alcuni casi di emoglobinuria paralitica nei cavallo. Profilassi, 1933, 6: 155-7.—Witzigmann, J. Die Myoglo- binurie des Pferdes. In Was gibt es Neues (Puttkammer, V.) Hannover, 1938, 181.—Wright, J. G. Insulin in the treatment of equine myoglobinuria. Vet. Rec, Lond, 1937, 17: 187-9. ---- Etiology. See also Anemia; Burns; Hemolysis; Lepto- spirosis, &c. Bass, M. H, & Ginandes, G. J. Hemoglobinuria in child- hood. Med. Clin. N. America, 1932, 15: 1085-104.—Bergmark, G. Ein Fall von intermittierender kryptogener Hamoglo- binurie. Acta med. scand, 1931-32, 77: 224-41.—Bingold, K. Ueber Ursachen und Symptome bei Hemolyse und Hamo- globinurie. Zschr. klin. Med, 1933-34, 128: 233-64.—Comby, J. Hemoglobinurie meta-pneumonique chez un enfant de 3 ans. Bull. Soc. med. hop. Paris, 1926, 3. ser, 50: 1267-9 — Frenkiel, H. Ein Fall von Hemoglobinurie bei einem Kinde nach Genuss von Rauschbeeren (Vaccinium uliginosum) Zschr. Kinderh, 1931-32, 52: 608-12.—Schally, A. O. Beitrag zur Aetiologie der kryptogenetischen paroxysmalen Hamo- globinurie. Zschr. klin. Med, 1934-35, 127: 697-712 — Wegelius, C. [Septic hemoglobinuria] Fin. lek. sail, hand, 1935, 78: 598-604.----— On septic hemoglobinuria, a casuistic contribution. Acta med. scand, 1936, Suppl. 78, 638-45.—Weil, P. E, & Stieffel, R. Etude d'un cas d'hemo- glohinurie par fragilite globulaire. Bull. Soc. med. h6p. Paris, 1926, 3. ser, 50: 1253-8.—Zaffagnini, A. Un caso di emoglobinuria in operato di appendicite. Arch. ital. urol, 1930, 6: 71-8. ---- experimental. Conti, L. Modificazioni ematologiche ed urologiche in una particolare forma di emoglobinuria sperimentale (nota prima) Boll. Soc. med. chir, Pavia, 1920, 33: 147-86.—Farkas, G., & Tangl, H. Die Wirkung der ultravioletten Strahlen auf die Farbstoffauswanderung aus dem Blute bei normalen und entmilzten Hunden. Biochem. Zschr, 1928, 200: 184-9 — Gasbarrini, A. Ulteriore contributo alio studio di una parti- colare forma di emoglobinuria sperimentale; su di un siero antiemoglobinurico. Boll. Soc. med. chir, Pavia, 1920, 33: 13-9.—Gilligan, D. R, Altschule, M. D., & Katersky, E. M. Studies of hemoglobinemia and hemoglobinuria produced in man by intravenous injection of hemoglobin solutions. J. Clin. Invest, 1941, 20: 177-87.—Komiya, E. Ueber die Hamoglo- binamie bei intravenoser Kollargolinjektion (eine weitere Mitteilung zur Untersuchung der durch Injektion von Kolloiden und Suspensionen hervorgerufenen Anamie) Tr. Jap. Path. Soc, 1929, 19: 369-75.—Minatoya, T. Durch Hamoglobinin- jektion verursachte Hamoglobinurie. Tohoku J. Exp. M, 1934, 24: 11-20. ---- malarial. See Malaria, Blackwater fever. ---- Methemoglobinuria. See also Hemoglobin, Methemoglobin: Forma- tion. Riedel, H. Studien uber Methamoglobinbildung; Harn. Arch. exp. Path, Lpz, 1938-39, 191: 609-14.—Simpson, E. S. A case of methaemoglobinuria followed by multiple neuritis. J. Ment. Sc, Lond, 1913, 59: 81-6.—Thienen, G. J. van [Methaemaglobinuria] Ned. tschr. geneesk, 1933, 77: 1086-92. ---- nocturnal [Marchiafava-Micheli] Arndal, P. [Case of chronic hemolytic anemia with noc- turnal paroxysmal hemoglobinuria] Ugeskr. laeger, 1940, 102: 115-22.—Buell, A, & Mettier, S. R. Paroxysmal noc- turnal hemoglobinuria with hemolytic anemia, Marchiafava- Micheli svndrome. J. Lab. Clin. M, 1940-41, 26: 1434-9 — Cort, E. C. Epidemiology of blackwater fever in Siam. Am. J. Trop. M, 1929, 9: 10.5-15.—Dacie, J. V., Israels, M. C. G, & HEMOGLOBINURIA 51S HEMOGLOBINURIA Wilkinson. J. F. Paroxysmal nocturnal haemoglobinuria of the Marchiafava type. Lancet, Lond, 1038, 1: 479-82.—Enne- king. J. Eine neue Form intermittiorender Hamoglobinurie (ha'Tooglobinuria paroxvsmalis nocturnal Klin. Wschr, 192S. 7: 2015 7 Fairley, N. H, & Bromfield, R. J. Pseudo- methaenin^lnbiu; it* -yntliesis from crystalbumin and alkaline haematin: p*en, In-met haemoglobin; its demonstration in the Miircluafava-Mielieli syndrome of nocturnal haemo- globinuria. Tr. R. Soc. Trop. M. Hyg, Lond, 1938-39, 32: 431-3.- -Fiessinger, N, & Parturier. G. Hemoglobinurie orthostatique; ictere hemolytique; amibiase urinaire; cure emetinienne; guerison. Bull. Soc. med. hop. Paris, 1926, 3. ser, 50: 153-v—Giglioli, G. Quartan malarial nephritis and malarial haemoglobinuria as family or house diseases in the interior of British Guiana; field observations on the epidemi- ology and etiology of blackwater fever. Riv. malariol, 1932, 11: 426-52.—Ham, T. H. Studies on destruction of red blood cells; chronic hemolytic anemia with paroxysmal nocturnal hemoglobinuria; an investigation of the mechanism of hemol- ysis, with observations on 5 cases. Arch. Int. M, 1939, 64: 1271-305—Scott, R. B, Robb-Smith, A. H. T, & Scowen, E. F. The Marchiafava-Micheli syndrome of nocturnal haemoglobinuria with haemolytic anaemia. Q. J. Med, Oxf, 1938, 7. ser, 25: 95-114, 2 pl.—Valcke, G, & Van den Berghe, L. Le syndrome de Marchiafava-Micheli, hemoglobinurie nocturne; observation clinique. Ann. Soc. beige med. trop, 1939. 19: 235-40. ---- paralytic. Sec subheading equine, paralytic. ---- paroxysmal. Guex, J. *Contribution a l'etude de l'hemo- globinurie paroxystique. 120p. 8? Par., 1927. Herrmann, K. *Zur paroxysmalen Haemo- globinurie [Frankfurt a. M.] 38p. 8? Bonn, 1929. Acuna, Vallino, M. T., & Macera, J. M. La hemoglobinuria paroxlstica en la infancia. Sem. med, B. Air . 1927. 34: pt 2, 801-5.—Adams, W. J. A case of paroxysmal haematuria; communicated to Glasgow Medico-Chirursrical Soe. Feb., 1879. Glasgow M. J, 1879, 4. ser, 11: 42 l-N.—Barkan, L. [Etiology of paroxysmal hemoglobinuria] Budapesti orv. ujs, 1029, 27: 741-3.—Barker, P. S. Paroxysmal hemo- globinuria; report of a case. Univ. Hosp. Bull, Ann Arb, 1935, 1: 6—Bosse, P., & Jaeger, K. H. Zur Frage der paroxys- malen Hamoglobinurie und ihrer Behandlung. Deut. med. Wschr, 1938, 64: 859.—Bragin, M. S, & Bazhenov. G. M. [Paroxysmal hemoglobinuria] Russ. klin, 1929, 12: 276-86.— Brule, M, Hillemand, P, & Gaube, R. Deux cas d'hemoglo- hinurie paroxystique; les difficultes du diagnostic clinique et hematologique. Bull. Soc. med. hop. ParK 1937, 3. ser, 53: 197-205.—Depelris, P. Hemoglobinuria paroxlstica esencial. Dia med, B. Air, 1938, 10: 4.">S-i>0.—Dickson, J. G. Paroxys- mal hemoglobinuria. U. S. Nav. M. Bull, 1030, 34: 300-6.— Dill, L. V., Douvros, I, & Isenhour, C. E. Observations on the incidence of latent paroxysmal hemoglobinuria as evidenced bv the Donath-Landsteiner phenomenon. Am. J. Syph, 1939, 23: 220-3—Dozsa. E. Ueber die Hamoglobinurie", mit besonderer Beriicksichtigung der paroxysmalen Hamoglo- binurie. Zschr. Urol, 1929, 23: 687-97.—Epstein, G. S. Un cas d'hemoglohinurie paroxystique. J. urol. med. Par, 1929, 28: 348-53.—Ernstene, A. C, & Gardner, W. J. The effect of splanchnic nerve resection and sympathetic ganglio- nectomy in a case of paroxysmal hemoglobinuria. J. Clin. Invest, 1935, 14: 799-805.—Fischer, O. Ueber die Entstehung der paroxysmalen Hamoglobinurie. Klin. Wschr, 1928, 7: 2061.—Garrote Vega, M, & Veragara Oliva, A. Comentarios acerca de un caso de hemoglobinuria paroxlstica. Arch. med. Madr, 1933, 36: 466-9.—Glassner, K. Welch.- Bedemuiiu; hat die paroxysmale Hamoglobinurie und wclche Behandlung i>t zu empfehlen? Wien. klin. Wschr, 1931. 44: 80.—Hall, S. C, jr, & Barksdale, E. E. Paroxysmal hemoglobinuria, with report of a case. Virginia M. Month, 1938, 65: 126-8 — Howard, C. P, Mills, E. S, & Townsend, S. R. Paroxysmal hemoglobinuria with report of a case. Am. J. M. Sc, 1938 196: 792-6—Huang, C. H, & Sia, R. H. P. Paroxysmal hemoglobinuria with a report of a case in a Chinese. Chin. M. J, 1936. 50: 214-20.—Ito, N. Paroxysmal hemoglobinuria; treatment by the inoculation of Spirochaeta morsus muris Am. J. Dis. Child, 1933, 46: 1062 5. Also repr.—Itoh, K. Beitrage zur Klinik der paroxysmalen Hamoglobinurie. Okayama igakkai zasshi, 1928, 40: 2420. ------ Ueber die Beeinflussung des Komplementgehalts durch Salvarsaninjek- tion. Ibid, 1929, 41: 1199.—Jacobson, A. Sulla emoglo- binuria parossistica. Chn. pediat. Mod, 1929, 11: 139-58.— Jaffe, L. Paroxysmal hemoglobinuria; case report. J. Michi- gan M. Soc, 1935, 34: 312.—Jedlicka, V, Bastecky, J, & Krai, J. [Principle of crises in paroxysmal hemoglobinuria, Cas. lek. cesk, 1930, 69: 1701-5.—Kalf-Kalife, M. J. [Cas1 of paroxysmal hsmoglobinurial Vrach. delo, 1928, 11: 115Ce 60.—Kasahara, M, Isuda, T., & Nagahama, M. Klinische Mudien uber die supravital granulierten Erythrocyten bei- Kinderkrankheiten; paroxysmale Hamoglobinurie. Zschr Kinderh., 1933, 55: 479-82 — Kelly, H. T. Paroxysmal hemo- globinuria; report of 2 cases. Pennsylvania M. J, 1934, 37: 393-5.— Korovitzkv. L. K. [Cases of paroxysmal hemoglo- binuria] Odess. med. J.. 1(127, 2: 246-50. Kumagui, T„ A Namba, M. Weitere Beitrage zur Kenntnis der paroxysmalen Hamoglobinurie. Deut. Arch. klin. Med, 1927, 156: 257-71.— Langeron, L. L'hemoglobinurie paroxystique. Prat. med. fr, 1926, 5: 163-78.—Lewis, S. J., & Fears, T. A. Paroxysmal hemoglobinuria, with a case report. Texas J. M, 1936-37, 32:403-5.—Lizzi, A. Paroxysmal hemoglobinuria. Marquette M. Rev, 1937-38, 2: 24-9.—Logue, R. B. Paroxysmal hemo- globinuria; report of case. J. M. Ass. Georgia, 1911, 30: 275.—Lupu, N. G, Nicolau, C, & Brauner, R. Observation sur un cas d'hemoglohinurie paroxystique. Bull. Soe. med. hop. Bucarest, 1928, 10: 53-62.—McCarthy, F. P., & Wilson, R, jr. Paroxysmal hemoglobinuria; report of cases, with familial finding*. N. England J. M, 1932, 207: 1019-22.- Mackenzie, G. M. Paroxysmal hemoglobinuria; a review. Medicine, Bait, 1929, 8: 159-91.------Observation on paroxysmal hemoglobinuria. J. Clin. Invest, 1929-30, 7: 27-43. ------ Paroxysmal hemoglobinuria. In Cyclop. Med. (Piersol-Bortz) Phila, 1939, 7: 660-72.—Misawa, T., Ohta, T, & Seino, K. Beitrage zur Kenntnis der Autohiimo- lysine der paroxysmalen Hamoglobinuriker. Zschr. Immun- forsch, 1932, 76: 386.—Nagibin, G. A. [Paroxysmal hemo- globinuria] Kazan, med. J, 1930, 26: 969-72.—Nossov, S. D. [Paroxysmal hemoglobinuria] Sovet. vrach. gaz, 1934, 38: 1764.—Paroxysmal haemoglobinuria. Lancet, Lond, 1911, 1: 667.—Paschkis, K. Zur Symptomatologie der paroxysmalen Hamoglobinurien. Med. Klin, Berl, 1930, 26: 51-4.— Phillips, J. T., jr, & Hogg, P. Paroxysmal hemoglobinuria; report of case in a child 4 years old. Virginia M. Month, 1939, 66: 737-40.—Pieri, J, Sardou & Battesti. Hemoglobinurie paroxystique. Bull. Soc. path, exot. Par, 1937, 30: 154-8.— Pilot, I, it Friedman, H. Paroxvsmal hemoglobinuria. Med. Clin. N. America, 1929-30, 13: 1231-3.—Puris, A. M. Paroxys- mal hemoglobinuria. Am. J. Dis. Child, 1929, 37: 1027-45.— Risak, R. Zur Frage der paroxysmalen Hamoglobinurie. Zschr. klin. Med, 1929, 111: 472-84.—Rosen, S. F. Paroxys- mal hemoglobinuria, with a case report. South. M. J, 1933, 26: 1038-44.—Roth, G. Paroxysmal hemoglobinuria with vasomotor and agglutinative features. Proc. Mayo Clin, 1935, 10: 609-15.—Schachsuwarly, M. Beitrag zur Frage der paroxvsmalen Hamoglobinurie. Arch. Schiffs Tropenhyg, 1932, 36: 336-43.—Schoonhoven van Beurden, A. J. E. van [Clinical and laboratory examinations in a case of paroxysmal hemoglobinuria] Ned. tschr. geneesk, 1935, 79: 1685-95.— Serra, C. L'emoglobinuria parossistica. Morgagni, 1931, 73: 1477-9.—Slot, G. Paroxysmal haemoglobinuria. Proc. R. Soc. M, Lond, 1929-30, 23: Sect. Clin, 27.—Strominger, L, & Gottfried, M. Sur un cas d'hemoglohinurie paroxystique avec recherches de laboratoire completes. J. urol. med. Par, 1926, 22: 45.—Swineford, O., jr. Paroxysmal hemoglobinuria. J. Lab. Clin. M, 1930-31, 16: 347-53.—Thurmon, F, & Blain, D. Paroxysmal hemoglobinuria; observations based upon a study of 3 cases. Am. J. Syph, 1931, 15: 350-67.—Videla, C. A, Savino, E, & Peonicini, J. Las hemolisinas en la hemo- globinuria paroxlstica. Rev. As. mid. argent, 1931, 44: 743-8, 3 ch. Also Dia med, B. Air, 1931-32, 4: 425.—Witeb- sky, E. Zur Frage der paroxysmalen Hamoglobinurie; Be- trachtungen und Versuchsergebnisse. Klin. Wschr, 1928, 7: 20-3.—Witts, L. J. The paroxysmal haemoglobinurias. Lancet, Lond, 1936, 2: 115-20.—Woofter, A. C, & Parks, B. S. Paroxysmal hemoglobinuria with report of a case. Ann. Int. M, 1938-39, 12: 402-6. ---- Pathogenesis. Stieffel, R. Contribution a l'etude des hemoglobinuries. 141p. 8? Par., 1928. Barcroft, J, Minett, F. C. [et al.] Discussion on haemo- globinuria. Proc. R. Soc. M, Lond, 1934-35, 28: 671-80 — Bravo y Frias. Contribucion casuistica al estudio de la hemo- globinuria en el nifio. An. Acad. nac. med, Madr. (1935) 1936, 55: 492-503.—Castex, M. R., Steingart, M., & Poletti, R. Hemoglobinurie: anemie aigue k regeneration erythroblastique intense. Sang, Par, 1932, 6: 589-94.—Drigalski, W. von. Ueber akute Porphyrie und Hamoglobinurie. Klin. Wschr, 1937, 16: 1779-82.—Jordan, F. L. J. Etudes sur l'hemoglo- binurie. Acta med. scand, 1938, 95: 319-40.—Kaunitz, H. Ueber Porphyrinurie nach Hamoglobinbelastung. Zschr. klin. Med, 1937-38, 133: 552-62.—Tropp & Borchardt. Studien uber Hamoglobinurie. Klin. Wschr, 1928, 7: 1059.— Varadi, S, & Michajluk, N. [Investigations on leukocytic and hemolytic changes and relation in paroxysmal hemoglobinuria] Sborn. 16k, 1939, 41: 1-63.—Wawrzykowska, E. I. [On the release of hemoglobin from the vascular system in hemolysis of the blood] Biull. eksp. biol. med, 1939, 8: 307-9. Also Bull. biol. med. exp. URSS, 1939, 8: 323-5.—Weil, P. E, & Ifticffel, R. Etude comparative des proprietes hemolytiques du plasma et du serum des hemoglobinuriques. Bull. Soc. med. hop. Paris, 1925, 3. ser, 49: 1553-6. ------ Influence du rechauffement sur le pouvoir hemolytique du plasma et du serum des hemoglobinuriques. C. rend. Soc. biol, 1925, 93:1560. ---- Renal threshold. Gersh, I. The site of renal elimination of hemoglobin in the rabbit. Anat. Rec, 1936, 65, 4: 371- 5—Havill, W. H, Lichty, J. A., jr, & Whipple, G, H. Renal tlireshold for hemo- HEMOGLOBINURIA 519 HEMOGLOBINURIA globin in dogs uninfluenced by mercury poisoning. J. Exp. M 1932, 55: 617-25. Also repr.—Lacoste, A, Aubertin, E, & Castagnou, R. Observations sur l'eiimination renale de I'hemo- globine. C. rend. Soc. biol, 1939, 132: 135. ------ Sur la destinee des produits d'eiimination hemoglobimques immo- bilises dans les reins et sur les reactions histo-pathologiques liees k cette immobilisation. Ibid, 137.—Lichty, J. A, jr, Havill, W. H, & Whipple, G. H. Renal thresholds for hemo- globin in dogs; depression of threshold due to frequent hemo- globin injections and recovery during rest periods. J. Exp. M, 1932, 55: 603-15. Also repr.—Lison, L. Zur Frage der iusscheidung und Speicherung des Hamoglobins in der Amphi- bienniere. Beitr. path. Anat, 1938, 101: 94-108—Manwell, E J & Whipple, G. H. Various hemoglobins and their renal thresholds in the dog. Am. J. Physiol, 1929, 88: 420-31.— Methaemalbumin and the elimination of cxtracorpuscular haemoglobin. Brit. M. J, 1940, 2: 229.—Mocsy, J. [Excretion of hemoglobin and myoglobin through the kidneys] Allatorv. lap, 1935, 58: 190-4.—Monke, J. V. The renal excretion of hemoglobin in the dog. Bull. School M. Univ. Maryland, 1940-41 25: 186. ------& Yuile, C. L. The renal clearance of hemoglobin in the dog. J. Exp. M, 1940, 72: L19-65. Also repr—Ottenberg, R, & Fox, C. L, jr. The rate of removal of hemoglobin from the circulation and its renal threshold in human beings. Am. J. Physiol, 1938, 123: 516-25.—Paterni, L: H rene emoglobinurico. Riv. malariol, 1928, 7: 659-89.— Smith, C. S. The elimination of hemoglobin by the kidney. Am. J. Physiol, 1928, 84: 574-6.—Webster, M. D, Engel, F. L. [et al.] The influence of ph upon the elimination of hemo- globin by the perfused frog's kidney. J. Cellul. Physiol, 1934-35, 5: 399-413.—Yuile, C. L, Steinman, J. F. [et al.] The tubular factor in renal hemoglobin excretion. J. Exp. M, 1941, 74: 197-202. --- toxic. See Hemolysis; also names of blood poisons as Mercury; Quinine; Sulfanilamide, &c. --- Treatment. Armentano, L, & Bentsath, A. Hamoglobinurie und Vita- min C. Klin. Wschr, 1936, 15: 1594-6.—Bushby, S. R. M, Hart, E. W. [et al.] Prevention of urinary suppression after intravascular haemolysis. Lancet, Lond, 1940, 1: 355-8.— Freger, E. Notes sur l'hemoglobinemie paroxystique et son traitement par les insufflations d'air dans le peritoine. Rev. path, comp. Par, 1915, 15: 272; 321; 397—Sterckx, F. Un cas d'hemoglohinurie grave traite par transfusion du sang. Ann. Soc. beige med. trop, 1928, 8: 161-3. --- Types. Schurger, G. *Ueber eine mit visceralen Spasmen einhergehende Haemoglobinurieform. 21p. 8? Erlangen, 1936. Altschule, M. D., & Gilligan, D. R. Acute, massive hemo- globinuria of obscure cause, with jaundice and anemia; report of a case with clinical and hematologic studies and measure- ments of the blood pigment metabolism. Arch. Int. M, 1941, 68: 957-78.—Badra, P. Sobre um caso de hemoglobinuria na infancia. Pediat. prat, S. Paulo, 1939, 10: 1-18.—Formijne, P. [Manifestations and types of paroxysmal hemoglobinuria; description of an independent, hitherto unrecognized form] Ned. tschr. geneesk, 1940, 84: 3394-402.—Huber, J, Florand, J. [et al.] Crises myopathiques paroxystiques avec hemo- globinurie. Bull. Soc. pediat. Paris, 1938, 36: 96-100.— Libman, E., & Fishberg, A. M. Unilateral hemoglobinuria: its occurrence in infarction of the kidney. Ann. Int. M, 1937-38, 11: 1344-7. Also in J. H. Pratt Anniv. Vol, 1937, 672-5.—Lo Passo, G. Un raro e strano caso di emoglobinuria infantile. Prat, pediat, Milano, 1934, 12: 407-17.—Rosenthal, F. Ueber eine neue Form von paroxysmaler Hamoglobinurie. Zschr. klin. Med, 1931-32, 119: 449-59.—Salen, E. B. Zum Begriffe Haemoglobinuria paroxysmalis; Bericht uber einen atypischen Fall intermittierender, echter Hamoglobinurie. Acta med. scand, 1927, 66: 566-87, 2 pl.—Smith, J. Hemo- globinuria in the newborn. Arch. Dis. Childh, Lond, 1930, 5: 275-82, pl.—Weber, F. P. Acute haemoglobinuria and anaemia in a boy. Proc. R. Soc. M, Lond, 1934-35, 28: 831.—Weir, J. F. Recurring acute hemolytic crisis with hemo- globinuria. Proc. Mayo Clin, 1933, 8: 110-6. --- in animals. Barnier, R. Contribution a l'etude des hemoglobinuries des animaux domestiques. 49p. 25J/2cm. Lyon, 1934. Ascani, E. Su di un caso grave di emoglobinuria parossistica folicemente risolto. Gior. med. vet, 1926, 75: 483; 497.—Cocu, J. Les inconnues de l'hemoglobinurie. Bull. Soc. centr. med. vet, 1927, 80: 333-5. ------ A propos de l'hemoglobinurie. Bull. Acad. vet. France, 1931, 4:95-8. ------ Un exemple de defaillance totale de I'etiologie classique dans un cas mortel de hemoglobinurie. Ibid, 1932,5: 382-5.—Cross, F, & New- som, I. E. A survey of icterohematuria in sheep in Colorado. Vet. Med, Chic, 1931, 26: 75-7.—Gastel, G. Un cas d'hemo- glohinurie k evolution anormale. Bull. Acad. vet. France, 1932, 5: 86-8.- Krishnan, K. V. Haemolytic agent in monkey haemoglobinuria. Annual Rep. All India Inst. Hyg, 1939, 32.— Olafson, P. Icterohemoglobinuria in sheep. Cornell Vet, 1930, 20: 232-8.—Stieffel, R. Contribution k l'etude des hemoglobinuries. Bull. Acad. vet. France, 1932, 5: 74-81. HEMOGRAM. See under Blood picture. HEMOLYMPH. See also Hemolymph node; Lymph heart. Arvanitaki, A, & Cardot, H. Solutions equilibrees pour le cceur des Helix en rapport avec la composition de l'hemolymphe. C. rend. Soc. biol, 1931, 106: 185-7.—Bacq, Z. M., & Kruta, V. Action de l'hemolymphe des invertebres sur le ventricule median des c6phalopodes. Arch, internat. physiol, Liege, 1936-37, 44: 216-18.—Beadle, L. C. Regulation of the haemolymph in the saline water mosquito larva Aedes detritus Edw. J. Exp. Biol, Lond, 1939, 16: 346-62.—Bernard, A. Sur la composition mineral de l'hemolymphe de differents Helix. C. rend. Soc. biol, 1931, 106: 183. ------ & Bonnet, V. Composition minerale de l'hemolymphe et etude d'une solution physiologique pour l'escargot. Ibid, 1930, 103: 1119.—Demjanowski, S, Galzowa, R, & Roshdestwenska, W. Wahre Aziditat der Hamolymphe von Bombyx mori L.; zur Kenntnis des Stoff- wechsels der Seidenraupen. Biochem. Zschr, 1932, 247: 386- 405.— Meyer, P. La pression colloido-osmotique de l'hemo- lymphe des Helix. C. rend. Soc. biol, 1935, 120: 1004. ------ La pression colloido-osmotique de l'hemolymphe de quelques tracheates. Ibid, 1005-7. ------ Contribution k la physio- logie physico-chimique comparee; la pression colloido-osmotique de l'hemolymphe de quelques invertebres terrestres. J. physiol. path, gen, 1936, 34: 448-53.—Teodoro, G. Recenti ricerche biochimiche sulla emolinfa del Bombyx mori L. Fisiol. & med, Roma, 1935, 6: 553-62.—Yeager, J. F, & Fay, R. W. Micro- method for determining insect hemolymph specific gravity (Periplaneta amencana Linn.) Proc. Soc. Exp. Biol, N. Y, 1934-35, 32: 1667-9. HEMOLYMPHANGIOMA. See also Blood vessel, Tumors: Angioma; Lymphangioma. Gilhaus, H. *Ein Fall von Hamolymphan- gioma mixtum [Munster] 13p. 8? Quaken- bruck, 1930. Cornbleet, T. Hemolymphangioma (preponderant heman- gioma transformed to lymphangioma) Arch. Derm. Syph, Chic, 1940, 41: 785.—Davies, J. H. T. Haemolymphangeioma. Proc. R. Soc. M, Lond, 1936-37, 30: 197.—Frieboes, W. Ueber ein Hamato-Lvmphangiom des Halses und der Zunge. Derm. Zschr, 1917, 24: Orig, 129-43.—Minne, J., & Loorius. Un cas d'hemolymphangiome du creux axillaire. Echo med. nord, 1934, 3. ser, 2: 611.-—Symmers, D. Primary hemangio- lymphoma of the hemal nodes; an unusual variety of malignant tumor. Arch. Int. M, 1921, 28: 467-74.—Weissenbach, R. J, & Levy-Franckel. Hemo-lymphangiome circonscrit k disposi- tion zoniforme. Bull. Soc. fr. derm, syph, 1935, 42: 251. HEMOLYMPH node. See also Hemolymph; Lymph node. Carere-Comes, O. Ricerche sulla frequenza e sul mec- canismo di formazione dei linfogangli ematofori (cosidetti gangli emolinfatici) nell'uomo normale ed in varie condizioni patologiche. Atti Accad. fisiocr. Siena, 1938, 11. ser, 6: 19. Sulla presenza e sul meccanismo di formazione di linfogangli ematofori (cosidette emolinfoghiandole false) neH'uomo in varie condizioni normali e patologiche. Boll. Soc. ital. biol. sper, 1938, 13: 73.------Ueber die menschlichen bluthaltigen Lymphknoten. Fol. haemat, Lpz, 1938, 59: 407-33.—Conversion (The) of lymph glands into haemolymph "lands by carcinogenic hydrocarbons. Annual Rep. Brit. Empire Cancer Campaign, 1940, 17: 155.—Helly, K. Hamo- Ivmphadrusen. Erg. Anat. Entwgesch, Wiesb. (1902) 1903, 12: 207-52.—Introzzi, P. Contributo alio studio delle ghiandole emolinfatiche. Boll. Soc. med. chir, Pavia, 1929, n. ser, 4: 595-619, pl.—Jordan, H. E. The significance of hemal nodes, J Morph, 1927, 44: 89-107, 3 pl. ------ Hemal nodes in man. Anat. Rec, 1934, 59: 297-310.—Macmillan, R. E. The so-called hemal nodes of the white rat, guinea-pig, and sheep; a study of their occurrence, structure, and significance. Ibid, 1928, 39: 155-69, 2 pl.—Naegeli, O. Ueber postembryonal Blutbildung im lymphatischen Apparat. Korbl. schweiz. Aerzte, 1904, 34: 204.—Selye, H, & Foglia, V. G. On the formation of hemolymph nodes during the alarm reaction. Am. J. Anat, 1939, 64: 133-42.—Selye, H, & Schenker, V. The haemolymph nodes of the rate (iron pigment lymph nodes) J. Anat, Lond, 1938-39, 73: 413-5, pl.—Weidenreich. Die Blutlymphdriisen und ihre Beziehung zu Milz und Lymph- drusen. Verh. Anat. Ges, 1902, 16: 47-58.—Weller, C. V. The hemolymph nodes. In Handb. Hemat. (Downey, H.) N. Y, 1938, 3: 1759-87, HEMOLYSIN 520 HEMOLYSIN HEMOLYSIN. See also Amboceptors; Erythrocyte, Serology; Hemolysis; also names of animals producing hemolytic venoms as Arachnida, &c. Arnaudi, C. Sopra uno pseudo-ambocettore emolitico del gelso. Boll. Ist. sieroter. milan, 1925, 4: 343-51.—Dujarric de la Riviere, R, Kossovitch, N, & Ishii, S. Sur l'hemolysine pancreatine. C. rend. Soc. biol., 1036, 122: 1170-3.—Henri, V. Considerations diverses sur 1'agglutination et sur les agglutmines, sur les precipitines, les hemolysines et les anti- toxines. Biol, med. Par, 1907, 5: 177-89.— Prunell. A. Reciprocite fonctionnelle, chez le lapin, entre l'hemolysine et les hematics sranulo-filamenteuses. C. rend. Soc. biol., 1932, 111: 531 - Salazar, M. Hemolisinas. Siglo med, 1926, 78: 2S1; 3(M'). Singer, E. Ueber hiimolytische Sera. Zschr. Immun- forsch, 1922. 35: Orig, 191-204. ---- Antibodies. See also Hemolysinogen. Bogaert, R. On the antihaemolytic action of normal serum. J. Physiol, Lond, 1937, 90: Proc, 68-70.—Carlinfanti, E., & Seal6. L. Ricerche vii potere antiagglutinante e antiemolitico dei sieri. Boll. Ist. sieroter. milan, 1936, 15: 697-700.—Chilla, A. Contributo alio studio dell'antiemolisi epatica; nota pre- ventiva. Rinasc. med, 1929, 6: 336.—Clark, H. M, Zinck, R. H, & Evans, F. A. Studies on some of the non-lipoid compo- nents of blood serum in relation' to its antihemolvtic property. Bull. Johns Hopkins Ifosp, 1921, 32: 328-36.—Farley, D. L. The inhibitory po\w r of human serum against digitonin (sa- ponin) hemolysin Bull. Aver Clin. Lab, 1938-39, 3: 331-4 — Jelmoni, P, & Pesenti, G. Sul potere antiemolitico dei sieri. Boll. Ist. sieroter. milan, 1940, 19: 95-9.—Radici. G,&Pesenli, G. Ricerche sul potere antiemolitico dei sieri agglutinanti. Ibid, 1937, 16: 379-82, pl.—Vandenbroucke, J. Une methode nepheiometrique pour measurer le pouvoir antihemolytique du serum snnguin. Acta brevia neerl, 1941, 11: 107-12.—Voigt, F. M, A- Voigt, C. An antihaemolytic serum. S. Afr. M. J, 1933, 7: 6S0-7.—Yanagihashi, M. On the anti-hemolytic action of hemolytic immune sera. J. Immun, Bait, 1928, 15: 421-63. ---- bacterial. See also proper names of bacteria as Anthrax bacillus; Cholera vibrio; Staphylococcus, &c. Bigger, J. W. The production of staphylococcal haemolysin with observations on its mode of action. J. Path, Cambr., 1933. 36: 87-114.—C6sari, E, Cotoni, L, & Lavalle, J. lb- rhcrclres sur l'hemolysine streptococcique. Ann. Inst. Pasteur Par, 1927, 41: 919-47.—Cohen, B., & Shwachman, H. Furt her observations on pneumococcal hemolysin and its inactivation J. Bact,. Bait, 1936, 31: 67.—Cowin, S. T. Pneumococcal haemolysin; its extra-cellular nature, production and properties. J. Path. Bact, Cambr, 1934, 38: 61-71.—Goldie, H. Les hemolysines non specifiques et les filtrats microbiens. C.rend. Soc. biol, 1932, 109: 82-^.—Gordon, J. The action of Congo red on streptococcal haemolysin and on B. welchii haemolvsin. J. Path. Bact, Lond, 1931, 34: 439-45. ------& Stansfield, F. R. Lecithin and streptococcal hemolysin. Brit. J. Exp Path, 1929, 10: 191-3.—ltd, R. Ueber die hochgradige Steigerung des Hamolysinbildungsvermogens des Streptococcus haemolyticus durch Nukleinsaure; Versuche zur Immunisierung von Kaninchen mit hochaktiven Streptolvsinpriparateii. .Jap J. M. Sc, 1940, 13: Proc. Pharm, 87.—Korobk.va, E. I. [Hemolytic properties of B. pestis and B. pseudotuberculosis rodentium] Vest, mikrob., 1940, 19: 3-1?.—Lesbre, P. Contingence du pouvoir heinolytique dan.- !'• croupe des st r epto- enterocoques. C. Tend. Soe. biol, 1926, 9">: 550-2.—Marchuk, P. D. [Staphylococcic and streptococcic hemolysins] J. med Kiev. 1937, 7: 449-56.—Naidu, P. M. N. Zur Hamolyse der Staphylokokken in Sehafhlutagarplatten. Zbl. Bakt, 1 Abt 1934. 132: 47-57.—Neter, E, & Uhry, E, jr. Demonstration of bacterial hemolysin in experimental and natural infections Arch. Path, Chic, 1937, 24: 405.—Norton, J. F, Verder, E., & Ridgway, C. The proteus hemolysin. J. Infect. Dis, 1928, 43: 458-60.—Smith, F. The relation of peptone to production of haemolysin by streptococci. J. Bact, Bait, 1937, 34: 585-601. ------ The influence of various substances and conditions upon streptococcal haemolysin. Ibid, 603-16.—Todd, E. W, & Hewitt, L. F. A new culture medium for the production o! antigenic streptococcal haemolysin. J. Path. Bact, Cambr 1932, 35: 973.— Trushina, E. F. [Streptococcal hemolysin] J. mikrob, Moskva, 1940, No. 10, 32-7.—Vassiliadis, P. C Hemolysines des vibrions choieriques vrais. C. rend Soc biol 1935, 119: 339-41. ---- Chemistry, physical properties, and na- ture. . Chow.^B. F, & Zia, S. H. Studies on the quantitative rela- tionship uetween hemolytic titre and agglutinin nitrogen of anti-sheep rabbit serum. Chin. M. J, 1940, 3: Suppl 495- 500.—Coulter, C. B The protein associated with hemolysin in rabbit serum and plasma. J. Gen. Phvsiol, 1926-27 10- 54o- >n— Doladilhe, M. La propriety anticorps de l'hemolysine -•st exercee par une substance isolablp du serum hemolytique. ( rend. Acad, sc, 1938, 206: 787.^ Girard, P.. & Lourau, M Premiers renseignements sur la nature et les proprietes physiques d'un anticorps: electrophorese des serums hemolytiques. Ann physiol. Par, 1934, 10: 991-4. Also C. rend. Acad, sc, 1931, 198:1081-3.------Klcctrophorese des serums hemolysants ct agRlutinants; proprietes eiectriques de l'hemolysine ot de ragglutinine. C. rend. Soc. biol, 1934, 116: 1010-2. (iojtony, L., & Hoffenreich, F. Untersuchungen uber die Natur der Serumhiimolysine. Zbl. Bakt, 1. Abt, 1929, 113: 277-81.— Nardi, F. Untersuchungen iiber die Konstitution der Hiinio- lysine der normalen Fischsera. Zschr. Immunforsch, 1038, 94: 505-20.—Paic, M. Sur la determination de la constante dc sedimentation de l'hemolysine. Ann. Inst. Pasteur, Par, 1938, 61: 873-6. ---— Ultraeentrifugation de l'hemolysine; determination de sa constante de sedimentation et de son poide moieculaire. Bull. Soc. chim. biol, 1939,21:412-21.- Piettre, M. Dans une serumalbumine hemolytique, l'activite specifiquc n'est pas liee k la totalite de la proteine. C. rend. Acad sc 1927, 184: 952-4.—Scaffldi, V. Ricerche sulle proprietA biologiche dei costituenti proteici del siero; capacita emolitica della albumina e della globulina dei sieri omolitici. Riv nat sper, 1928. 3: 265-70. ' ---- Extraction, and isolation. Doladilhe, M. Contribution au probleme de l'extraction de l'hemolysine. C. rend. Acad, sc, 1939, 208: 1439-41 Also C. rend. Soc. biol, 1938, 129: 1118.—Tropp, C. Ueber Absprengbarkeit und Ambozeptorfunktion der an Kaolin gehundenen hamolytischen Antikorpcr. Zschr. Immunforsch 1931, 70: 289-301.—Tsu, T. Y. Adsorptionsversuche mit hamolytischen Antikorpern. Ibid, 223-39. ---- Formation. Fels, H. *Studien zur Hamolysinbildung. 47p. 8? Bonn, 1931. Mundschenk [L. H.] E. *Ueber Hamolysin- bildung beim Kaninchen unter Wirkung von Bleiacetat [Bonn] 36p. 8? Soltau, 1930. Bickert, F. W. Ueber Hamolysinbildung beim Kaninchen unter Bleiwirkung. Zschr. Immunforsch, 1929, 60: 297- 336.—Cionini, A. Sulla influenza esercitata dal bloccagsun del .sistema reticolo-endoteliale nella produzione di antioorpi emolisine. Gior. batt. immun, 1927, 2: 65-93.—Fox, C. A, & Whitehead, R. W. Effect of cortico-adrenal extract onhemo)- ysin formation in normal adult animals. Am. J. Physiol, 1935, 113: 44.—Franza, R. Influenza della leucocitosi speri- mentale sulla produzione di ambocettori emolitici. Boll Soc. ital. biol. sper, 1928, 3: 714-9.—Gross, H. Ueber den Einfluss parenteral gegehener Lipoide auf die Hamolysin- bildung bei Kaninchen. Zbl. Bakt, 1. Abt, 1928, 109: 8-10. ----— Untersuchungen iiber die Rolle der Individualitiit und deren mogliche Beeinflussung durch oral gegebene Lipoide fur die Hamolysinbildung bei Kaninchen. Ibid, 339-41.— Gualdi, A. Effetti dei Raggi X sulla produzione biologica di emolisine. Boll. Accad. med. Roma, 1934, 60: 254-60 — Illenyi, A, & Borzsak, L. Der Einfluss des vegetativen Tonus auf die Bildung des Hemolysins. Zschr. Immunforsch, 1938, 94: 79-83.—Lusztig, A. Die Wirkung der Mangansalze auf die Hamolysinbildung. Zbl. Bakt, 1. Abt, 1931-32, 123: 376-8.—Marotta, G. Influenza del glicosio sulla produzione ed azione degli anticorpi emolitici. Mem. Accad. Italia, 1931, 2: biol. No 2, 1-13, ch.—Merlini, A. Raggi Rontgen ed emolisine. Arch, radiol. Nap, 1928, 4: 158-66.—Muller, L. Lieu d'origine des anticorps hemolytiques. C. rend. Soe biol, 1920, 83: 203.—Peretz. L. G. [Formation of antibodies against the erythrocyte in rabbits and in cases of malaria] Kazan, med. J, 1925, 21: 903-9.—Pfanner, F. Apporto metalhco e produzione di ambocettore emolitico (contributo sperimentale e teoretico) Haematologica, Nap, 1927, 8: 177-211.—Stanton, A. H, Meunning, L. [et al.] Spinal-cord section and hemolysin production in the rat. J. Bact, Bait, 1942, 43: 99.—Varshamov, L. A. [Problem of specific cyto- toxic stimulation in the production of hemolysin by the macro- phage elements of the mesenchymal J. mikrob, Moskva, 1925, 2: 35-41.—Zernoff, V. Les reflexes conditionnels dans Aoorolatl0n hemolysines. rj. rend. Soc. biol, 1934, 116: ---- heterophile. Andersen, T. Untersuchungen uber Schafhamolysine und ;noma?5lu^lne ln Menschenseren. Zschr. Rassenphysiol, 1938, 10: 166-80.—Belding, D. L. Natural antisheep hemol- ysins in guinea pig serum. Am. J. Hyg, 1929, 9: 735-40 — Bessemans, A, & Nelis, P. L'irradiation ultra-violette et fo?»tlold? hetero-hemolysin.es. C. rend. Soc. biol, 1928, 99: 329-31.—Bruynoghe, R. Les hemolysines hetero- genics. Rev. med, Louvain, 1934, 248-53.—Charpentier, 1 " f*olad,lhe> M-> & Morel, C. Localisation de l'hemolysine naturelle anti-mouton du serum humain dans la proteine visqueuse. C. rend. Soc. biol, 1937, 125: 700.—Di Macco, G. Modificazioni del potere emolitico naturale e dolle emolisine secondane dopo introduzione parenteral di siero o emazie eterogenee. Riv. pat. sper, 1928, 3: 523-30—Ekzem- pbarskaia, E. V. [Normal hemolysines in animals, containing heterogenous antigen in the erythrocytes] Arb. Microb. Inst. Volksunternchtskom, Moskva, 1928, 4: 255-8. Also Zbl. HEMOLYSIN 521 HEMOLYSIN Bakt, 1. Abt, 1928, 109: 341-4.—Fujioka, N. Ueber das Vorkommen heterophiler H&molysine in den Menschensera verschiedener Gruppen und ihr Verhaltnis zu den Isoanti- korpern. Zschr. Immunforsch, 1928, 59: 239-54— Goldie, H. Recuperation et stabilisation de l'agglutinine antibacterienne: et de l'hemolysine anti-mouton du serum. C. rend. Soc. biol, 1936, 121: 761-4.—Lim, C. E, & Wong, D. H. Production of anti-sheep hemolysin in a donkey. Proc. Soc. Exp. Biol, N. Y, 1931, 29: 256-9.—Rubinstein, P. L. [Contents of normal heterophile hemolysin in guinea pigs and rabbits] J. mikrob, Moskva, 1926, 3: 393-403. Also Zschr. Immun- forsch, 1927, 50:114-25.—Scaffidi, V, & Cerbone, R. Ricerche sulla emolisi specifica; produzione di emolisine antimammiferi in uccelli. Riv. pat. sper, 1934, 13: 243-53. ------& Gatto, N. Ricerche sulla emolisi specifica; sul potere litico spontaneo dei sieri per le emazie eterologhe; capacity alessinica sec. Buchner. Ibid, 1935, 14: 25-46— Scaffidi, V., & Moracci, E. Ricerche sulla emolisi specifica; ricerche sulla produzione di emolisine antimammiferi in uccelli. Ibid, 1934-35, 12: 29-49.—Seiffert, W. Hamolysine gegen Hammelblutkor- perchen in Paratyphus- und Giirtnerseris. Zbl. Bakt, 1. Abt, 1929, 114:285-90. ---- Hypothermolysin. See Hemoglobinuria, cold. See also Amboceptors; Complement. Andrei, G. Su alcuni fattori che modificano la produzione delle emolisine specifiche. Gior. batt. immun, 1926, 1: 665- 74.—Gross, H. Die Konservierung hamolytischer Immunsera mit Chinosol. Zbl. Bakt, 1. Abt, 1929, 111: 315.—Iijima, T. Studies on sensitized antigen, with special reference to the production of haemolytic immune-bodv. Sc. Rep. Inst. Infect. Dis, Tokyo, 1923, 2: 141-64.— Kabrhel, G, & Kredba, M. [Decrease of ha>molysins in serum of immunized animals] Cas. lek. Cesk, 1923, 62: 585; 621.—Lovaglio, R. Reazioni ematiche nella produzione sperimentale di emolisine. Minerva med. Tor, 1933, 24: pt 2, 771-6.—Lourau, M. Evolution des courbes de titrage des hemolysines antiporc au cours de la sensihilisation. C. rend. Soc. biol, 1938, 127: 1200-2.— Rosenthal, F., & Friedlander, E. Reticuloendothel und Immunkorperbildung; uber den Ablauf der Hamolysinbildung bei schwer geschadigtem Reticuloendothel. Zschr. ges. exp. Med, 1933, 87: 1-16.—Schultze, H, & Gross, H. Fraktio- nierung und Konzentrierung hamolytischer Immunsera. Bio- chem. Zschr, 1929, 215: 11.5-25.—Tedeschi, C. Sulle modi- ficazioni strutturali da siero emolitico. Sperimentale, 1934, 88: 93-111.—Toyoshima, R. A comparative study on a production of hemolysin through the injection of red blood- corpuscles into the normal and pathologic tissues; a comparison of the production of hemolysin through the injection of red blood-corpuscles into the normal and tumour tissues. Sei i kwai, 1928, 47: No. 9, 5. ------ The further investigation on the region of immunological hemolysin formation by the injection of red blood-corpuscles into the tumour tissues. Ibid, 1929, 48: No. 5, 3. ------ On the morphological changes of red blood-corpuscles injected into the tumor tissues. Ibid, H. 12, 9.—Velicogna, A. L'azione della calciocianamide sulla produzione di emolisine specifiche. Gior. batt. immun, 1933, 11: 1048-53.—Wasfy Omar. The effect of exposure of animals to ultra-violet rays on their ability to produce haomolysins. J. Egypt. M. Ass, 1935, 18: 168. ---- immune: Manufacture. Balls, A. K, & Korns, J. H. On the mode of action in vitro and the preparation of hemolytic antibodies. J. Immun, Bait, 1918, 3: 375-87— Basilieva, V. N. [Intrapulmonary injection of red corpuscles of a ram as method of securing hemolytic amboceptor] Vrach. delo, 1926, 9: 1407-10.— Beattie, M. A new method for the production of antisheep hemolysin. J. Lab. Clin. M, 1934, 19: 666.—Becker, M. Zur Frage der Bereitung von hamolvtischem Serum. Zbl. Bakt, 1. Abt, 1926, 99: 568.—Borowskaja, D. P. Zur Frage der Bereitung von hamolytischem Serum. Ibid, 98: 425-7. ----- Fiinf Jahre Gebrauch von hamolytischem Pferdeserum. Ibid, 1930, 118: 63-5.—Kosakai, M. The isolation, purifica- tion and concentration of immune bodies; a study of immune hemolysin. J. Immun, Bait, 1918, 3: 109-30.—Moragas, R. Metodo para la r&pida producci6n de hemolisina conejo- anticarnero. An. Hosp. S. Cruz, Barcel, 2: 166.—Pontano, T. Criteri di scelta degli animali per la produzione dei sieri emolitici ad alto titolo. Policlinico, 1928, 35: sez. prat, 1815-7.— Uchida, S. The isolation, purification and chemical nature of immune hemolysins. J. Infect. Dis, 1927, 40: 588-96. Also repr.—Yasaki, M. Ueber die Herstellung " hochwertiger Rinderhaemolysinsera. J. Chosen M. Ass, 1938, 28: 78. ■---- natural. See also Blood, Bactericide power. Bergenhem, B, & Fahrseus, R. Ueber spontane Hamo- lysinbildung im Blut, unter besonderer Berucksichtigung der Physiologie der Milz. Zschr. ges. exp. Med, 1935-36, 97: 555-87.—Chiarotti, C. Rapporti tra gruppi sanguini ed alessina secondo Buchner; potere litico spontaneo per le emazie eterologhe. Gior. batt. immun, 1939, 23: 117-23.—Euler H von, & Card, S. Studien iiber ein hamolytisches Normal- serum Zschr. Immunforsch, 1931, 72: 113-28.—Gama, L. A. da. Contribuicao ao estudo do poder hemolftico do sangue em alguns estados normais e patol6gicos nos indigenas de L,oa. Arq. Esc. med. cir. Nova Goa, 1928, ser. A, 219-38 — Ooldie, H. Stabilite de l'hemolysine naturelle dans le milieu fan^"'Que Pauvre en sels. C. rend. Soc. biol, 1938. 128: fO7-70—Hyde, R. R. The reactivation of the natural hemo- lytic antibody in chicken serum. Am. J. Hyg, 1921. 1: 358- 63—Jadin, J Les hemolysines naturelles des serums humains. C. rend. Soc. biol, 1930, 103: 951-3—Misawa, T. Beitrage zur Kenntnis von Natur der Normal hamolysine. Jap. J. M. Sc, 1932, 1: pt 7, Tr, 105-73.—Racchiusya, S. Studio sull'e- mohsina con tenuta nei siero di sangue della Cerna gigas (Cuv. e Val.) Gior. batt. immun, 1935, 14: 1240-60.—Ramon, G, & Richou, R. Hemolysine normale et hemolysine acquise. C. rend. Soc. biol, 1933, 113: 1423-5.—Rossi, P. II potereemo- 1 itico naturale del siero di sangue di donna nei vari momenti del ciclo mestruale. Fol. demogr. gyn, Genova, 1939, 36: 225-34.—Scala, A, & Alessandrini, A. II potere emolitico del siero di sangue e la sua probabile origine. Ann. igiene, 1924, 34: 549-82.—Scartozzi. C. Emolisine naturali e alessina secondo Buchner in varie specie animali, anche in confronto col quadro proteico. Gior. batt. immun, 1938, 21: 858-89. ---- Specificity. Cerbone, R. Ricerche sulla emolisi di gruppo e sulla speci- ficity dell'adsorbimento della emolisina con emazie. Riv. pat. sper, 1939, 23: 241-66.—Hyde, R. R. The specificity of hemolytic antibodies. Am. J. Hyg, 1925, 5: 217-27. Also Anat. Rec, 1924, 29: 87. ---- Standardization, and titration. Coulter, C. B. The precise measurement of hemolysin. J. Gen. Physiol, 1926-27, 10: 541-4.—Crosnier, R. Determina- tion et calcul de la sensibilisation dans les reactions de fixation du complement par titrage k dose fixe de serum hemolytique (systeme hemolytique anti-mouton) C. rend. Soc. biol, 1936, 121: 1306-8.—Dold, H, & Gross, H. Weitere Studien iiber den Einfluss der Technik und anderer ausserer Faktoren auf die Titerhohe hamolytischer Amboceptoren. Med. Klin, Berl, 1926, 22: 1302-5.—Euler, H. von, & Brunius, E. Ueber die Reinigung hamolytischer Antikorper. Zschr. Immunforsch, 1930, 68: 124-36.—Fabre, R. Sur un procede spectrophoto- metrique d'etude de l'hemolyse. C. rend. Acad, sc, 1926, 182: 1574-6. Also J. pharm. chim. Par, 1926, 8. ser, 4: 247-50.—Gaucher, L. Serum hemolytique anti-mouton, desseche et stabilise. C. rend. Soc. biol, 1926, 94: 652.— Gonzalez, P. Titulacio d'hemolisines. Tr. Soc. biol, Barcel, 1915, 3: 289.—Ipsen, J. Reaction curves of hemolysins. Acta path, microb. scand, 1938, Suppl. 38, 149.—Kalinin, W. S, & Ginsburg, S. J. Ueber das Konservieren hamolytischer Sera. Zschr. Immunforsch, 1927, 53: 112-7.—Kilduffe, R. A. The stability of glycerinated antisheep hemolysin. Arch. Path, Chic, 1929, 7: 113.—Laubenheimer, K., & Vollmar, H. Ueber die Fraktionierung des hamolytischen Amboceptorserums. Zschr. Hyg, 1926, 106: 202-8.—Lourau, M. Anomalies des courbes de titrage de quelques serums hemolytiques. C. rend. Soc. biol, 1938, 127: 133-6.—Noyons, A. K. L'etude de l'hemolyse par 1'extinctiometrie. Arch, internat. physiol, Liege, 1921, 18: 250-68.— Paic, M, & ChorokhofT. Dosage precis de l'activite hemolytique relative. Bull. Soc. chim. biol. Par, 1938, 20: 684; 947.—Ponder, E. The use of the stufenpho- tometer for measuring percentage hemolysis. Proc. Soc. Exp. Biol, N. Y, 1929-30, 27: 821-3.------& Yeager, J. F. The use of nth equations to describe the action of simple hemolysins. Proc. R. Soc, Lond, 1930, ser. B, 106: 506-31.—Simorin, A. M. [Colorimetric standards for various stages of hemolysis] Vest. mikrob, 1928, 7: 198-201. ---- Toxicity. See also Allergy; Hemolysis, Pathology; Shock. Doladilhe, M. Proprietes anaphylactiques de l'hemolysine. C. rend. Acad, sc, 1938, 206: 1150.—Michelazzi, I, Sopra il potere tossico degli immunsieri emolitici. Pathologica, Genova, 1933, 25: 564; 638. ---- Variation. Aresu, P. Contributo alia conoscenza dell'azione delle onde corte sul complemento e sulle emolisine. Boll. Soc. ital. biol. sper, 1938, 13: 1159-61.—Chopra, R. N, & Roy, A. C. The effect of Seitz filtration on haemolysins and the components of a haemolytic system. Ind. J. M. Res, 1938, 26: 303-9— Jokl, E. Ueber Beeinflussung der immunbiologischen Normalstruktur des menschlichen Serums durch Korperarbeit; das Verhalten der hamolytischen Kraft des aktiven Serums sowie des Normal- hammelblutamboceptors im inaktivierten Serum. Zschr. ges. Neur. Psychiat, 1930, 129: 460. —Kilduffe, R. A. A further note on the stability of glycerinated antisheep hemolysin. J. Lab. Clin. M, 1939-40, 25: 376.—Lumifere, A, & Couturier, H. Influence des pressions <* levies sur les proprietes hemolyti- ques des serums. C. rend. Soc. biol, 1927, 96: 45.—Mazzeo, M, & Visconti, P. Ambocettori emolitici e soluzioni calciche, 22 HEMOLYSIS HEMOLYSIN Fol. med. Nap, 1935, 21: 899-913.—Merlini, A. Raggi Rontgen ed emolisine (ricerche sperimentali) Arch. Soc. ital. chir. (1927) 1928, 34: 749.—Mussa, B. Sulla termoresistenza delle emolisine antimontone. Gior. batt. immun, 1929, 4: SYS-67. -Nolf, P. Action du chloroforme sur les proprietes hemolytiques du plasma de chien. Bull. Acad. Belgique, 1922, 5. ser, 8: cl. sc, 466-78.—Sartori, P. S. . Delle modificazioni apportate dall'ultranltrazione con la candela di Chamberland ai sieri ed ai L. C. R. Wassermann-positivi, al compleinonto emolitico, e all'emolisina. Pathologica, Genova, 1925, 17: 457-60.—Schmidt, H., & Gross, H. Ueber den Einfluss von Elektrolyten als Beimischung zur physiologischen Kochsalz- losung auf die Titerhohe hamolytischer Ambozeptoren. Bio- chem. Zschr . 1929, 215: 61-8.—Tsevetkova, A. E, & Prigorov- skaia, P. V. [Effect of ultra-violet rays on the titre of the hemolytic amboceptor in vivo and in vitro] J. mikrob, Moskva, 193$, 20: No. 3-4, 78-80.—Zironi, A. Sulla termoresistenza delle emolisine. Atti Soc. lombard. sc. med, 1924, 13: 437. HEMOLYSINOGEN. See also Hemolysin; also names of hemolysin producing antigens as Erythrocyte; Exudate; Fibrinogen; Milk, &c. Heden, K. Ueber die Entstehung von Forss- manshamolysinen und komplementbindenden Antikorpern nach intravenosen Injektionen von Wasser- und Lecitinkolesterinfiltraten aus ver- schiedenen Organen an Kaninchen und Menschen. 74p. 8? Helsin., 1936. Horino. K. Ueber die spezifische Hamolyse; das Lysinogen der Ervthrocyten und seine neue Reaktion. J. Biochem, Tokyo," 1928, 9: 435-44.—Ito, R. Ueber die hochgradige Steigerung des Hamolysinbildungsvermogens des Streptococcus haemohticus durch Nukleinsaure; iiber die Bedeutung der Tetranucleotid-Konstitution der Nukleinsaure als wirksamer Faktor bei der Streptolvsinbildung des Streptococcus haemo- lyticus. Jap. J. M. Sc, 1940, 13: Proc. Pharm, 85-7.— Minatoya, T. Antigen des durch Leukozytenimmunisierung gebildeten Hamolysins. Tohoku J. Exp. M, 1934, 23: 231- 40.—Okamoto, H. Ueber die hochgradige Steigerung des Hamolysinbildungsvermogens des Streptococcus haemolyticus durch Nukleinsaure. Jap. J. M. Sc, 1939-40, 12: Proc. Pharm, 113-5.—Perondi, C, & Boccuni, C. La produzione di emolisine negli animali trattati con vaccini hatterici. Boll. Soc. ital. biol. sper, 1939, 14: 502. HEMOLYSIS. See also Blood chemistry, Urobilin; Blood groups, Hetero-reactions; Complement fixation, Mechanism; Cytolysis; Hemolysin. For non- specific hemolysis see also Erythrocyte, Re- sistance. Chessa, F. Contributo alia conoscenza dell'emolisi distret- tuale. Boll. Soc. ital. biol. sper, 1938, 13: 1147.— Diacono, H. Esposizione generale delle cause o delle modality del fenomeno emolitico. Biol, med, Milano, 1935, 11: 303; 371; 411.— Egami, Y. Difference individuelle dans le degre de l'hemolyse et le facteur qui la determine. Keijo J. M, 1936, 7: 596-611.— Gollwitzer-Meier, K. Ueber Blutkorperchenquellung und Hamolyse. Biochem. Zschr, 1923, 139: 86-113.—Gorter, E. Ueber Hamolyse. Mschr. Kinderh, 1933, 57: 205-8.—Manai, A. Sulla metodica per lo studio dell'emolisi in vitro. Diagn. teen, lab. Nap, 1935, 6: 367-87.—Netter, H, & 0rskov, S. L. Objektive Registrierung der Hamolyse mit Sperrschicht- photozellen. Arch. ges. Physiol, 1932-33, 231: 135-9 — Raynor, G. F. Hemolysis. J. Am. Inst. Homeop, 1929, 22: 100-4. ---- Acceleration. Hotta, K. Einige Erfahrungen uber Hamolysebeschleuni- gung. Zschr. Immunforsch, 1925, 45: 453-60.—Neuda, P. Ueber Hamolyseverstarkung. Ibid, 1937, 91: 112-33.— Ponder, E. Acceleration of hemolysis in relation to chemical structure; the C-10 alcohols. Proc. Soc. Exp. Biol, N. Y, 1941,48:602. ------ The effect of temperature and of Iysin concentration on the acceleration of hemolysis. J. Gen. Physiol, 1941-42, 25: 247-61. ---- bacterial. Bechtel, E. *Ueber das Phanomen der Hamolyrsp durch Einwirkung von Bakteriophagen [Frankfurt a. M.] p.340-9. 8? Jena, 1931. Also Zbl. Bakt, 1. Abt, 1931, 119: Clauberg, K. W. Ueber die Beziehung zwischen der bak- tenellen Hamolyse in flussigen Medien und den Aufhellungs- zonen um Kolonien blutlosender Mikroben auf der Platte Zschr Hyg, 1929, 110: 442-58.—Finkelstein, M. H. The (Hemolytic properties of cholera, para-cholera and allied vibrios with special reference to their effect on blood media. Brit j' Exp. Path, 1929-30, 11: 54-64.—Herbert, D. A simple colorimetric method for the estimation of haemolysis and its application to the studv of streptolysin. Biochem. J, Lond, 1941, 35: 1116-23.—Kollath, W., & Taubmann, G. Experi- mentelle Untersuchungen liber Bakterienhamolv.se. Zbl. Bakt, 1. Abt, 1927, 104: 252-6, 2 pl.—Kortenhaus, F. Zonen- zyklohamolyse auf Blutagar bei Staphylokokken sowie bei Viridans-Streptokokken und Pneumokokken. Ibid, 1929, 113: 499-503. 2 pl.—Lavergne, V. de, & Kissel, P. Hemolyse micro- bienne et cholesterologene.se; etude in vitro. C. rend. So,. biol, 1933, 114: 1014. Matsunaga, K. Investigation con- cerning the influence of salts on the hemolytic action of the bacterial cells of streptococci and other conditions that deter- mine the hemolysis. Kitnsato Arch, 1933, 10: 207-19.— Muller, L. Recherches sur le mecanisme de certaines hemo- lyses d'origine bacterienne. ('. rend. Soe. biol, 1927, 96: 189- 93.—Ponder, E, 2G HEMOPHILIA Schloess.mann, H. Die Hemophilic 306p. 8? Stuttg., 1930. Schwendv, J. *Ueber Hiimophilie [Heidel- berg] 34p. 8? Gutersloh, 1936. Tartter, E. *Ueber Haemophilie [Heidel- berg] 28p. 8? Bergzabern (Pfalz) 1930. Bernstein. B. B. Hemophilia. Dent. Items, 1940, 62: 028-31.—Birch. C. L. Hemophilia. Proc. Soc. Exp. Biol, M. Y, 1930-31, 28: 752. Also J. Am. M. Ass., 1932, 99: 1566- 72. Also repr. Also Med. Woman J, 1932, 39: 83-5. Also Med. Clin. N. America, 1933, 17: 351-6S.--Cheva»ier. P, & Goldberg, R. Les hemophilics. Rev. med. Par., 1931, 48: 126-92.—Davidson, L. S. P. Haemophilia, ln Brit. Encycl. M. Pract. (Rolleston, H.) Lond, 1937, 6: 123-9.—De la Maza, V. Hemofilia. Rev. chilena pediat, 1941, 12: 564-7.—Eley, R. C. Hemophilia. Internat. Clin, 1936, 40. .ser., 2: 202; passim. Also Med. Clin. N. America, 1937, 21: 375-88.— Fonio, A. Die Hamophilie. Erg. inn. Med. Kinderh, 1930, 51: 443-530.—Hemophilia. Scalpel, Gainesville, Fla, 1933, 4: 12-4.—Howell. W. H. Hemophilia. Bull. N. York Acad. M, 1939, 15: 3-20. — Krauss, H. Die Bluterkrankheit. Allg. Deut. Hebam. Ztg, 1926, 41: 239-41.—Kurusu, M. Ueber die Hamophilie. Mitt. Med. Akad. Kioto, 1929, 3: 20.—Lawrence, C. S. Hemophilia. South. M. & S, 1926, 88: 171-3.—Mac- farlane, R. G. Haemophilia: a short survey. S. Barth. Hosp. J, Lond, 1931. 39: 47-54.—Mills, C. A. Hemophilia. J. Lab. CUn. M, 1932, 17: 932-41.—Opitz, H. Ueber Hamophilie. Krg. inn. Med. Kinderh, 1926, 29: 628-85. ------ Die Bluterkrankheit. Med. Welt, 1933, 7: 833-5.—Pickering, J. W. The recognition, treatment, and aetiology of haemophilia. Lancet, Lond, 1929, 1: 1239-42.—Podolsky, E. The conquest of hemophilia. Am. J. Pharm, 1939, 111: 288-92.—Schub, Z. H. [Hemophilia] Stomatologia, Moskva, 1937, No. 2, 88- 90.—-Strumii, M. M. Hemophilia. In Cyclop. Med. (Piersol- Bortz) Phila, 1939, 2: SO 1-5.—Zavadier, S. Haemophilia. S. Afr. M. J, 1935, S: 780. ---- Associated diseases. Bonadies, A. Sopra un caso di appendicitc asint.omatica in un soggetto emofiliaco. Policlinico, 1926, 33: sez. pint., 829- 31. Connolly, A. J. Haemophilia complicated bv duodenal ulcer. Nurs. Times, Lond, 1941, 37: 844.- Lord, J. P. Hemo- philia with Volkmann syndrome. Tr. West. Surg. Ass. (1925) 1926, 35: 49-54.—Macciotta, G. Episodio di favismo in bambino emofiliaco. Pediatria (Riv.) 1936, 44: 1-6.—Rath, B. Rotgrunblindheit in der Calmbacher Blutersippe; Nachweis des Faktnrenaustausch beim Menschen. Arch. Rassenb, 1938, 32: i97-4l)7. -Turner, J. M. Haemophilia; tuberculous hip; luemopliiliae knee; tuberculous abscess of abdominal wall. Pmc. U. Soc. M.. Lond.. 1933, 26: Orth, 46.—Ulrich, K. Hamonliagisrli-nekroti.sierende Sclileiiiihautentziindung bei Kombination von Hamophilie und Sepsis. Beitr. Anat. Ohr, 1927, 25:281-91. ---- Blood. See also subheading Hemostatic system. Baar, H, & Szekely, L. Ueber die Plattchenzerfallsge- schwindigkeit bei normalen Kindern, bei der Hamophilie und Thrombopenie. Zschr. Kinderh, 1929, 48: 31-42.—Christie, R. V.. Sendroy, J, & Van Slyke, D. D. The distribution of electrolytes in haemophilie blood. Q. J. Med, Oxf, 1928-29, 22: tlj-71.—Heyl. E. Ueber Blutveranderungen bei Hamo- philie. Klin. Wschr, 1939, 18: 960-3.—Leder. Beitrag zur Kenntnis der trypanoziden Substanz im Blutserum bei Hamo- philie. Munch, med. Wschr, 1928. 75: 562—Lee, P, & Erickson, B. N. Platelet studies in menstruation and hemo- philia; total and differential counts, disintegration rates and lipid distributions. Proc. Soc. Exp. Biol, N. Y, 1938-39, 39: 264-7.—Leichtentritt & Opitz. Untersuchungen iiber die trypanoziden Serumsubstanzen bei Hamophilie. Med. Klin Berl, 1927, 23: 59.—Macht, D. I, & Rowe, G. D. A phyto- physiological examination of hemophilic blood. Proc. Soc Exp. Biol, N. Y, 1926-27, 24: 649.—Platelets in haemophilia. Med. J. Australia, 1941, 2: 63.—Werner, O, & Hartmann, E. Untersuchungen uber die trypanociden Serumsubstanzen bei Hamophilie. Med. Klin, Berl, 1926, 22: 1803. ---- Blood group. Kubanyi, E. [Hemophilic blood groups in families] Orv. hetil, 1926, 70: 4-6. Also Klin. Wschr, 1926, 5: 321.------ Blutgruppenuntersuchungen an der hiimophilen Familie Mampel zu Heidelbers. Ibid, 1927, 6: 1517-9.------ Weitere Untersuchungen uber die Beziehung zwischen Hamo- philievererbung und Bluttrruppencharakter. Ibid, 1931, 10: 597-601.—Lofgren, S. Ueber Konduktorenbestimmung' und Blutgruppenverteilung bei Hamophilie. Ibid, 1937, 16: 1782-5.—Moritsch, P. Die gute Wirkung der Bluttransfusion bei einem Fall von Hamophilie und die Blutgruppenbezie- hungen in einer hiimophilen Familie. Wien. klin. Wschr 1926 39: 842. ---- Casuistics. Albrecht, W. [E. L. J. M.] *Ueber Haemo- philie, mit einem kasuistischen Beitrag. 36n 8? Lpz., 1928. ' Arrigoni. R. Sopra un caso di cmofilia sporadica. Morgagni 193-'. 74: 023 -30. -Balyeat, F. S. Hemophilia; a short review' with report of 2 cases. Pacific 1 ><-nt. Gaz, 1928, 36: 297-300.— Cunningham, J. J. A case of hemophilia and its treatment Dent. Cosmos. 1934, 76: 1263-5.—Feissly, R, & t'urchod, }{'. Etude d'un cas d'hemophilie sporadique. Hev. med. Suisse rom, 1925, 45: 808 -79— Flesch, A. [Hemophilia of childhood| Mag\'. orv. nag\ het jegvzbkve, 1933, 3: IS7. Also (hvoskepzes 1933, 23: 856 70— Froelich. Un cas d'hemophilie. Rev' m6d. est, 1927, 54: 414-6.—Griinor, T. [Case of hemophilia) LijeC. vjes, 1940, 62: 460.—Koopman, J. [Case of hemophilia Geneesk. gids, 1928, 6: 654-8.—Mathez, A. Deux cas d'hemo- philie. Rev. m6d. Suisse rom, 1927, 47: 464-81.—Nelson, K. M, & Boyle, H. A. A case of haemophilia. J. R. Army M. Corps, 1936, 66: 117-9.—Pi-Suner Bayo, J. I'n case /2cm. Munch., 1938. Also Arch. Rassenb, 1938, 32: Pfenninger, H. *Der Stammbaum der Bluter von Wald (Zurcher Oberland) 1550-1932, mit besonderer Berucksichtigung der Blut- gruppenzugehorigkeit. p.49-72. 8? Ziir., 1934. Also Arch. Julius Klaus Stift, 1934, 9: Anzen, G. Three children of the same family with haemo- philia. Acta paediat, Upps, 1933-34, 15: 117-20. ----- [Three brothers with hemophilia] Hygiea, Stockh, 1934, 96: 215-8.—Barboni, U. L'erediti nell'emofilia; illustrazione di un nuovo albero genealogico. Boll. Soc. eustach, 1927, 25: 40-9.—Birch, C. L. Some American hemophiliac families. Proc. Inst. M. Chicago, 1934, 10: 138.—Boggs, R. Spontaneous hemophilia; report of 6 cases in brothers. Am. J. M. Sc, 1934, 188: 811-5.—Bonis, F. [History of a hemophile family Oy6gydszat, 1935, 75: 42.—Del Sei, M. Contribuci6n al estudio de la hemofilia familiar. ' Sem. m6d, B. Air, 1928, 35: pt 2, 1085-98.—Denechau & Bigot. A propos d'un cas d'hemo- philie familiale. Arch. m6d. Angers, 1926, 30: 74-6.—Fonio, A. Der neue hiimophile Stammbaum Pool-Pool aus Soglio, Bergell (Kanton Graubiinden) Zschr. klin. Med, 1933, 125: 129-43 — Foresti, C. B. Hemofilia familiar. An. Fac. med, Montev, 1931, 16: 424-46.—Gunder, R. Mitteilungen iiber neue Blutersippen. Arch. Rassenb, 1939, 33: 355-64, 4 ch.— Gun, W. T. J. Haemophilia in the Royal caste. Eugen. Rev, Lond, 1937-38, 29: 245.—Hernandez Loeches, R. Historia de una familia de hemofflicos. Rev. med. cubana, 1929, 40: 311-7.—Hoessly-Haerle, G. T. Der Stammbaum der Bluter von Tenna. Arch. Julius Klaus Stift, 1930-31, 5: 303-90, 22 ch, map.—Job, L. Hemorragie gastro-intestinale et hemo- philic familiale. Bull. Soc. obst. gyn. Paris, 1934, 23: 272.— Kaneko, G, & Amagasa, S. Zwei grosse Haemophilie-Familien. .lap. J. M. Sc, Tokyo, 1930-32, 2: Int. Med, 127.—Klug, W. J. Ueber die Kirchheimer Bluterfamilien (Mampel) Deut. Zschr Chir, 1926, 199: 145-51.—Kubanyi, E. [Haemophilia in families in Hungary] Orv. hetil, 1931, 75: 177-81.—Lari, G. I.. Studio di una famiglia emofiliaca con particolari manifestation! HEMOPHILIA 527 HEMOPHILIA dell'apparato dentale. Atti Congr. internaz. stomat. (1935) 1936, 2. Congr, 2: 1049.—Le Marc'hadour, Breton & Bourno- ville,' P. Hemophilic familiale. Echo med. nord, 1931, 35: 89-91.—Lukowski, L. Five generations of hemophilia; a supplement to the knowledge of hereditary tendency to bleed- ing. J. Hered, 1927, 18: 213.—Macklin, M. T. Sex ratios in families with hemophilia. Am. J. Dis. Child, 1939, 58: 1215- 27.—Madlener, M. Eine Bluterfamilie. Arch. Rassenb, 1927-28, 20: 390-4.—Mirri, A. L'emofilia familiare. Gior. Soc. ital. igiene, 1926, 48: 293-8.—Monteleone, R. Osserva- zioni cliniche e ricerche ematologiche in una famiglia di emo- filici. Policlinico, 1926, 33: sez. prat, 361-5.—Motta Pacheco, A A. Consideracoes em torno de uma familia de hemophilicos. Rev. med, S. Paulo, 1933-34, 17: 35-60, 2 ch, 2 pl—Ruther- furd, W. J. A pedigree of haemophilia. Brit. J. Child. Dis, 1932, 29: 267-82.—Traum, E., Schaaff, G., & Linden, H. Beitrag zur Frage der Konduktorenbestimmung in hamophilen Familien. Klin. Wschr, 1931, 10: 111-3.—W. Das Ver- hiltnis der Geschlechter in Familien mit Hamophilie. Schweiz. med. Wschr, 1941, 71: 182.—Weinberg, W. Eine weitere Bluterfamilie. Arch. Rassenb, 1926, 18: 437.—Williamson, C S, & Birch, C. L. A case of hemophilia, with genealogical chart. Med. Clin. N. America, 1927, 11: 169-77. ---- female. Morcos, G. *Le probleme de l'hemophilie feminine; etude critique. 125p. 25cm. Lyon, 1939. Schulke [W. A.] H. *Ueber Haemophilie bei Frauen. 4p. 8? Bonn, 1931. Bauer, H, & Meller, J. Zur Frage der weiblichen Hamo- philie. Zschr. klin. Med, 1936, 130: 445-60. Also Med. Khn, Berl, 1937, 33: 268-71. Also Wien. klin. Wschr, 1937, 50: 495-9.—Bauer, K. H, & Wehefritz, E. Gibt es eine Hamophilie beim Weibe? Arch. Gyn, Berl, 1926, 129: 1-22 — Brummer, P. ICase of hemophilia-like diathesis in .a woman] Duodecim, Helsin, 1939, 55: 7So-94. Also Nord. med, 1939, 4: 3714-7.—Female bleeders. Brit. M. J, 1934, 2: 594; 700.— Haldane, J. B. S, & Philip, U. The daughters and sisters of haemophilics. J. Genet, Cambr, 1939-40, 38: W3-200.— Leak. W. N. Female bleeders. Brit. M. J, 1934, 2: 921 — Oelhafen, sr. Ueber einen Fall von Hamophilie. Med. Korbl. Wurttemberg, 1930, 100: 141.—Paliard, F, Etienne- Martin, P. [et al.] Un cas d'hemophilie chez une jeunefillede 17 ans. Lyon med, 1938, 162: 208-12.—Paliard, F, Jeune, M, & Revol, L. L'hemophilie chez la femme; k propos d'une observation. J. med. Lyon, 1938, 19: 679-87.------Le probllme de l'hemophilie feminine. Quest, med. actual., Par, 1939, 9: No. 1, 1; No. 2, 1.—Peiper, A. Sporadische Haemophilie bei einem Madchen. Med. Welt, 1937, 11: 1492.—PferovskS?, K. [Hemophilia in women] Bratisl. 16k. listy, 1931, 11: 26; 57; 97; 145.—Priselkov, M. [Case history of female hemophilia] Russ. klin, 1928, 9: No. 45, 28-34.— Rosenthal, N, Vogel, P., & Beres, D. Acquired hemophilia in a female. In Anniv. Vol. (R. T. Frank) S. Louis, 1937, 320-6.—Schultz, W. Zur Kenntnis der Hamophilie bei mannlichen und auch weiblichen Verwandten. Fol. haemat, Lpz , 1930, 42: 310-22.—Vavasour, E. A. Are women haemo- philie? Med. Press & Circ, Lond, 1936, 193: 463. ---- Frequency. Campbell, E. P. Hemophilia in the Negro; report of a case. Med. Ann. District of Columbia, 1939, 8: 294.—Crandall, N. F. Hemophilia in the Negro. Am. J. M. Sc, 1936, 192: 745-51, pl—Fischer, M. Die Verbreitung der Bluterkrankheit. Volk & Rasse, 1936, 11: 14-6.—Fonio. A, Lang, E, & Tillman, A. Die Bluterkrankheit im Kanton Bern. Arch. Juhus Klaus Stift, 1937, 12: 495-574, 5 pl.—Fonio-Langnau, A. Die Bluterkrankheit im Kanton Bern. Klin. Wschr, 1937, 16: 1698.—Lang, E. Die Hamophilie im Kanton Bern, in geo- graphischer, erbbiologischer, klinischer und gerinnungsbiolo- gischer Hinsicht. Ausz. Inaugur. Diss. Med. Fak. Univ. Bern (1935-37) 1938, No. 105, 1.—Muir, J. Heredity in hiemo- philia in South Africa. J. M. Ass. S. Africa, 1928, 2: 599- 606— Pachman, D. J. Hemophilia in Negroes; 3 cases and 2 genealogic charts. J. Pediat, S. Louis, 1937, 10: 809-16.— Rattan, B. Haemophilia in the tropics. Brit. M. J, 1928, J: 844.—Trowell, H. C. A case of haemophilia in a Muganda. East Afr. M. J, 1940-41, 17: 464.—Weinberg, W. Weitere Falle von Haemophilie in Wurttemberg. Arch. Rassenb, 1925, 17: 319-21. ---- Hemostatic system. Brandes, W. *Kann die Gerinnungsstorung der Hamophilie auf Vermehrung des Blutfluorge- halts zurtickgefuhrt werden? 16p. 8? Bresl., 1931. n , + ■ , Bendien, W. M., & Creveld, S. van. On spme factors of blood coagulation, especially with regard to the problem ol hemophilia. Acta med. scand, 1939, 99: 12-27—Brandes, W. Ueber die angebliche Anwesenheit von Fluor im Blute des Hamophilen. Zschr. klin. Med, 1931-32, 119: 504-7 — Brinkhous, K. M. A study of the clotting defect in hemophilia; the delayed formation of thrombin. Am. J. M. be, 1939, 198: 509-16. Warner, E. D, & Smith, H. P. Rate of thrombin formation in normal and in hemophilic blood. Arch Path, Chic, 1939, 28: 767. Also repr.—Castex, M. R, & Re, P. M. Coagulaci6n y glucolisis en la hemofilia. Prensa med. argent, 1931-32, 18: 1039-44.—Christie, R. V, Davies, H. W, & Stewart, C. P. Studies in blood coagulation and haemophilia; observations on haemic functions in haemophilia, Q. J. Med, Oxf, 1926-27, 20: 481-98.—Creveld, S. van. Investigations on haemophilia; the coagulation promoting activity of preserved blood and plasma. Acta brevia neerl, 1940, 10: 191-5.—Dam, H, & Venndt, H. [Investigation on coagulation anomalies in hemophilia] Ugeskr. laeger, 1939 101: 1443-5. Also Lancet, Lond, 1940, 1: 70-2.—Dyckerhoff, H, & Goossens, N. Ueber die Art der Blutgerinnungsstorung bei Hamophilie. Zschr. ges. exp. Med, 1938, 104: 116-9.— Eagle, H. Studies on blood coagulation; the nature of the clotting deficiency in hemophilia. J. Gen. Physiol, 1934-35, 18: 813-9.—Evans, P. S, & Howell, W. H. Does hemophilic blood contain an excess of an anticoagulant? Am. J. Physiol, 1931, 98: 131-4.—Feissly, F. Physio-pathologie des troubles de la coagulation dans les etats hemophiliques. C. rend. Congr. fr. med, 1922, 16. sess, 255-9.—Feissly, R, Fried, & Oehrli, H. A. Hamophilie und Blutfluor. Klin. Wschr, 1931, 10: 829.—Freeman, E. T. Notes on haemophilia (with recent experiments on clotting time and their influence on treatment) Irish J. M. Sc, 1933, 6. ser, 87: 122-8.—Fritsch, R. H. Neue Untersuchungen zur Blutgerinnung bei physiologisch hamo- philen Tieren. Zschr. Geburtsh. Gyn, 1936, 113: 324-39. Also Mschr. Geburtsh. Gyn, 1937, 105: 237. Also Zbl. Gyn, 1937, 61: 52-4.—Grunke, W. Studien iiber die Blutgerinnung mit besonderer Berucksichtigung der Hamophilie; Einfluss des Harnes auf die Gerinnung hamophilen Blutes. Zschr. ges. exp. Med, 1935, 96: 512-6. ------ Die Bedeutung der Blutplattchen und der Erythrocyten fiir die Gerinnung. Ibid, 1936, 99: 438-46. ------ Die hamophile Gerinnungsstorung im Vergleich zu anderen naturlichen und kiinstlich erzeugten Gerinnungsverzogerungen. Ibid, 1937, 101: 585-92. ------ Kiinstliche Erzeugung hamophilieartiger Gerinnungsverzoge- rung (in vitro) Ibid, 593-6.------& Koletzko, J. Einfluss des Harnes auf die kiinstlich verzogerte (hamophilieartige) Gerinnung des Plasmas. Ibid, 1939, 105: 46-52.—Hartmann, E. Ueber das Wesen und die Beseitigung der Storung der Blutgerinnung beim Hamophilen. Deut. med. Wschr, 1926, 52: 1709.------Weitere Untersuchungen iiber das Wesen der hamophilen Gerinnungsstorung. Ibid, 1927, 157: 274-9.— Howell, W. H, & Cekada, E. B. The cause of the delayed clotting of hemophilic blood. Am. J. Physiol, 1926, 78: 500-11.—Lozner, E. L, & Taylor, F. H. L. The coagulation defect in hemophilia; studies of the clot promoting activity associated with plasma euglobulin in hemophilia. J. Clin. Invest, 1939, 18: 821-5. ------& Kark, R. The coagulation defect in hemophilia; the clot promoting activity in hemophilia of berkefelded normal human plasma free from fibrinogen and prothrombin. Ibid, 603-8.—McKhann, C. F., Chu, F. T. [et al.] Character of the blood clot in normal persons and in hemophiliacs. Am. J. Dis. Child, 1936, 52: 1278.—Mills, C. A. Blood clotting studies in hemophilia. Am. J. Physiol, 1926, 76: 632-41. Also repr.—Patek, A. J, jr, & Stetson, R. P. Hemophilia; the abnormal coagulation of the blood and its relation to the blood platelets. J. Clin. Invest, 1936, 15: 531-42.—Patek, A. J, jr, & Taylor, F. H. L. Hemophilia; some properties of a substance obtained from normal human plasma effective in accelerating the coagulation of hemophilic blood. Ibid, 1937, 16: 113-24.—Pohle, F. J, & Taylor, F. H. L. The coagulation defect in hemophilia; the effect in hemophilia of intramuscular administration of a globulin substance derived from normal human plasma. Ibid, 1938, 17: 741-7. ------ The coagulation defect in hemophilia; studies on the refractory phase following repeated injections of globulin substance derived from normal human plasma in hemophilia. Ibid, 779-83 Also repr.—Serio, F. Sulla coagulazione del sangue emofiliaco. Boll. Soc. ital. biol. sper, 1927, 2: 583.—Tapie, J. L'action comparee des globules blancs normaux et des cellules leucemiques sur la coagulation in vitro du sang des grands hemophiles. C. rend. Congr. fr. med, 1922, 16. sess, 260-2 — Weil P E. La coagulation du sang chez les hemophiles. Bull.'med, Par, 1932, 46: 753. ---- Heredity [and eugenics] See also subheading Family studies. Baum E. *Die Hamophilie als Erbkrankheit. 23p. 8? [Berl., 1934] Also Med. Welt, 1934, 8: 1168-70. Haas, F. *Hamophilie im Nicht-Inzuchtsge- biet; eine genealogische und erbbiologische Studie [Munchen] 55p. 21cm. Speyer 1938 Halverscheid, E. *Ueber die Erblichkeit der Hamophilie mit besonderer Berucksichtigung der scheinbar sporadischen Formen. 44p. 8? Bonn, DeLacey M. Haemophilia in a twin. Lancet, Lond, 1931, .,. 1074— Erbbiologie (Ueber) und Eugenik der Bluterkrank- heit Zschr. arztl. Fortbild 1936, 33: 535-Fischer, M Vererbungslehren der Bluterkrankheit. Umschau, 1930, 34: HEMOPHILIA o '28 HEMOPHILIA 1-4.------Hamophilie und Blntsverwandtschaft. Zschr. ges. Anat, 2. Abt.. 1931-32, 16: 502-12. ------ Bluter- krankheit und Verwandtenchen. Oeff. Gesundhdienst, 1935-36. 1: B, 265-9.—Fonio. A. Ueber das Vorkommen einer latenten hiimophilen Erbanlagc bei klinisch nicht hamophilen Sohnen einer Bluterfamilie nebst weiteren gerinnungsbiolo- gischcn Untersuchungen. Zschr. klin. Med, 1933-34, 126: 424-32.—Haldane. J. B. S. The location of the gene for haemophilia. Genetica, Gravenh, 1938 20: 423-30.—Levit, S. G, A: Malkova. N. N. A new mutation in man; hemophilia-a. J. Hered, 1930, 21: 73-7.—Macklin, M. T. Heredity in hemo- philia. Am. J. M. Sc, 1928, 175: 218-24.— Mills. C. A. The transmission of hemophilia. J. Am. M. Ass, 1930, 94: 1571. Also repr.- Niss6, B. S. The evidence of transmission of haemophilia through the male with a new haemophilie pedigree. Ann. Eugen, Cambr, 1926-27, 2: 25-40.—Orel, H. Ueber die Vererbung der Bluterkrankheit. Aerztl. Prax, Wien, 1930, 10: 207. Also Wien. klin. Wschr, 1935, 48: 853—Schloess- mann, H. Die Hamophilie in ihrer Bedeutung als Erbkrank- heit. Arch. klin. Chir, 1935, 183: 371-86 [Discussion] 101-6. Also Chirurg, 1935, 7: 332-8.------Die Hamo- philie mit besonderer Beriicksichtigung ihrer Bedeutung als Erbkrankheit. Zbl. Chir, 1935, 62: 1540-8. ------ Hamo- philie und Verhiitung erbkranken Nachwuchses. Ibid, 1939, 66: 1683-6. —Schroder, C. H. Beitrag zur Vererbung und Behandlung der Hamophilie. Miinch. med. Wschr, 1935, 82: 1281-4. ---- Historical data. Klapersak, J. *Altes und Neues iiber Haemo- philie. 42p. 8? Lpz., 1926. Sommerlad, G. [F. W.] *Geschichte der Hamophilie. 56p. 8? Lpz., 1927. Gordon, H. L. L'emofilia; il morbo di Simeone ben Gama- liele. Policlinico, 1934, 41: sez. prat, 1486-93.—Schachter, M. Quelques precisions concernant Tinstone de l'hemophilie. Bull. m6d., Par, 1933, 47: 251.—Sendrail. M.. & Shnyderovitz, A. L'hemophilie familiale et le Talmud. Paris m6d, 1935, 96: annexe, 186. ---- .Manifestation. Baud, Y. *Les poussees hemorragiparcs au cours de l'hemophilie familiale. 158p. 8? Lyon, 1936. Arbuse, D. I, & Locascio, N. R. Neurological manifesta- tions in hemophilia. Med. Rec, N. Y, 1937, 146: 377-81.— Damade, It, Deriviliee, P., & Barroux, R. Hemophilic spora- dique avee episode hemogenique initial. Paris med, 1935, 95: 439-44.—Gasbarrini, A. Emogeno-emofilia. Riforma med, 1933, 49: 1013-6.—Jeannin. Considerations sur les hemorragies presentees par 3 hemophiles congenitaux. Lyon med, 1932, 150: 476-80.—Lapiccireila, V. L'emogeno-emofilia. Riv. clin. med, 1927, 28: 817-25.—Maggi, R. Hemogeno- hemofilia. Arch, argent, pediat, 1931, 2: 497-507.—Tejerina Fotheringham, W, & Palamedi, B. A proposito deun caso de hemofilia con purpura. Sem. med, B. Air, 1927, 34: pt 2 157-9. ---- Metabolism. Dreyfus. C. Vitamin C und Hamophilie. Schweiz. med. Wsehr.. 1935, 65: 10.—Haas, de [Hemophilia and vitamine C] Geneesk. tschr. Ned. Indie, 1935, 75: 1595.—Norcorss, J. W. Hemophilia and avitaminosis C; report of a case. Lahey Chn. Bull, 1940-42, 2: 219-22. ---- neonatorum. See under Hemorrhagic diathesis. ---- Pathogenesis. Das Xeves, A. J. *Contribuigao para o estudo da hemophilia. 63p. 8? Lisb., 1886. Bendien, W. M, & Creveld, S. van. Investigations on haemophilia. Acta brevia neerl, 1935, 5: 135; 1937 7: %■ 83 Also Am. J. Dis. Child, 1937, 54: 713-25. Also Mschr. kinder- geneesk, 1936, 5: 179; 1937, 6: 186. Also Progr. med. Par, 1937, 1441.—Birch, C. L. Assay of the estrogenic hormone in hemophilic and normal male urine. Proc. Soc. Exp Biol N. Y, 1941, 48: 167.—Boldyrev, W. N. Haemophilia; its physiological essence; experimental data. Tohoku J Exp M 1937, 31: 469-78.—Collaud, A. Nouvelles contributions' k l'etude de l'hemophilie et des causes des hemorragies spon- tanees dans cette maladie; vitesse de sedimentation; essais theiapeutniues. Schweiz. med. Wschr, 1926, 56: 219-26.— Copley A. L, <& Lalich, J. J. The experimental production of a hemophilia-like condition in heparinized mice. Am. J. Physiol. 1941-42, 135: 547-56.—Domarus, A. von. Zur Kenntnis der Hamophdie. Klin. Wschr, 1931, 10: 446-50.—Feissly. R Beitrage zum Wresen und zur Therapie dor Hamophilie. Jahrb Kinderh 1925, 3. F, 60: 297-308—Fieschi, A. Ricerche sull emofilia. Chn. med. ital, 1932, 63: 560. Fonio, A. Der gegenwartige Stand der Haemopbiliefrage. Med. Welt, 1938 12: 513; 586.—Frank, E., & Hartmann, E. Ueber das Wesen und die therapeutische Korrektur der hftmophilcn (ierinnungs- storung. Klin. Wschr, 1927, 6: 435-9.—Fuchs, H. J.. 4 Falkenhausen. M. von. liber das Wesen der Hiimophilie Ibid.. 1930, 9: 92S 30.—Fujii. (). Studien iiber Hiimophilie .lap. J. M. Sc, 193C, 4: Int. Med, 71-183— Govaerta, P., 4 Gratia, A. Contribution a l'etude de l'hemophilie. Rev. beige sc. med, 1931, 3: 689-95.—Izzo, C. Etiopatogenesi e cura deU'emofilia. Gior. ital. mal. esot, 1934, 7: 41; 66.—Kugel- mass, I. N. Mechanism of hemophilia in infancy and in child- hood. Am. J. Dis. Child, 1932, 44: 50-68.' Also repr.— Kup, G. [Endocrine bases of haemophilia] Budapesti orv ujs, 1939, 37: 689; 730; 757.—Lenggenhager, K. Die Lcisung des hamophilen Blutungs- und Gerinnungsriltacls. Mitt Grenzgeb. Med. Chir, 1935-36, 44: 425-39.—MarzoBo, e! Emofilia e lue. Gior. ital. derm, sif, 1935, 76: Suppl, 69-74.— Novodvorsky, V. M, & Kozlovskaia, Z. I. [Pathogenesis and therapy of hemophilia] Tr. Acad. mil. med. Kiroff, 1934, 1: 105-10.—Samson-Himmelstjerna, H. Cedanken uber das Wesen der Hamophilie und ihre ursachliche Behandlung Sven. liik. sail, hand, 1925, 51: 207-12. Also Miinch. med Wschr, 1926, 73: 980 9. Also Med. J. A Rec, 1926, 124: 329-32. Also repr.— Silberstein, J. Contribucion al estudio de la hemofilia. Rev. mid. Rosario, 1928, 18: 101-18, 4 pl — Stuber, B., & Lang, K. Ueber Hiimophilie. Verh. Deut. Ges inn. Med, 1928, 40. Kongr, 370-3. Also Zschr. klin. Med ' 1928, 108: 423; 1930, 113: 599.—Suzuki, T, Kimura. S, 4 Ohta, F. Contribution to the problem of hemophilia. Tohoku J. Exp. M, 1936- 37, 30: 389-97.—Wittkower, E. Ein Beitrag zur Hamophilie. Klin. Wsehr, 1926, 5: 2167. ---- Pathology. Maier, W. R. *Die Vulnerabilitat und Labilitat der Capillaren bei Haemophilie [Tu- bingen] 45p. 8? Sulz a. N., 1931. Bernuth, F. von. Ueber das Verhalten von Capillaren bei Blutungsubeln. Klin. Wschr, 1926, 5: 2262.— Brovelli, M. Ricerche. sul potere battericida del sangue degli emofiliaei Boll. Soc. med. chir, Pavia, 1938, 52: 153-65.—Custer, R. P., & Krumbhaar, E. B. The histopathology of (he hemopoietic tissues in hemophilia; an unexplored field. Am. J. M Sc 1935, 18?: 620-30, 2 pl.------Histology of the hemopoietic tissues in hemophilia. Arch. Path, Chic, 1935, 20: 9,~>7.— Korovnikov, A. F. [Hemophilia and the bone marrowl Sovet vrach. J, 1937, 2: 009-14— Mills, C. A, & Schiff, L. Passive anaphylaxis in a hemophiliac. Am. J. M. Sc, 1926, 171: 854.—Riecker, H. H, & Lichty, D. E. Anaphylaxis in hemo- philia. J. Lab. Chn. M, 1928-29, 14: 708-13. ---- Prognosis. Struzina, R. *Das Schicksal der Hamophilie unter besonderer Berucksichtigung der Bluter, die seit dem Jahre 1915 in der Universitats- kinderklinik Breslau behandelt wurden. 15p. 22^cm. Bresl., 1937. Bickel, B. Can the tendency to bleed be overcome in persons suffering from haemophilia? Internat. Clin, 1929, 39. ser, 2: 294.—Lehndorff, H. Prognose und Behandlung der Blu- tungsubel im Kindesalter. Arch. Kinderh, 1934, 103: 98-108. ---- pseudo. See Hemorrhagic diathesis. ---- Sequelae. Deloge, G. C. J. *Quelques observations de paralysies consecutives k des hdmatomes chez les h6mophilies. 59p. 8? Par., 1935. Achard, C, Bariety, M. [et al.] Sur un cas mortel de grande hemophilic Bull. Soc. med. hop. Paris, 1931, 3. ser, 47: 863-9.—Botros Salib. An unexpected cause of death in a haemo- philie infant. J. Egypt. M. Ass, 1936, 19: 763.—Frilnkel, W. K. Komplette Radialislahmung durch Hamatom bei einem hamophilen Kinde. Med. Welt, 1930, 4: 330.—Gunther, H. Ueber Lahmungen bei Hamophilie. Mschr. Psychiat, 1935, 91: 33-40.—Hill, R. L. Volkmann's ischemic contracture in hemophilia. Tr. Hawaii M. Ass, 1939, 49: 26-31.—Kissin- ger, P. Todliche Blutungen bei einem Hamophilen nach seliwerem Heben. Aerztl. Sachverst. Ztg, 1928, 34: 319 — bord, J P. Hemophilia with Volkmann syndrome; report of case. I. Am. M. Ass, 1926, 87: 406.—Paltrinieri, M. Osserva- zioni di retraziom ischemiche di Volkmann in emofilici. Bull. sc. med. Bologna, 1939, 111: 203-13. ------ Su un caso di Paralisi di mediano-ulnare in un emofilico. Ibid, 1940, 112: 230-4.—PasquaM, E. Emofiha e retrazione isehemica di Volkmann. Chir. org. movim, 1930-31, 15: 465-75.—Seddons, H. J. Haemophilia as a cause of lesions in the nervous system. Brain, Lond, 1930, 53: 306-10. ---- Site of hemorrhage. Birch. C. L. The otolaryngological manifestations of hemo- philia. Ann. Otol. Rhinol, 1938, 47: 540-7. Also Arch. Otolar Chic, 1938, 27: 504-8— Dujarier. Un cas tfhemo- phihe laryngee. Arch, internat. laryng. Par., 1930, 36: 1216- HEMOPHILIA 529 HEMOPHILIA 20 —Fahr, T. Verblutung in die Muskulatur bei einem Hiimo- philen. Deut. Zschr. Chir, 1936-37, 248: 208-13.—Fernandez, J. G, Giustinian, V, & Carri, M. A. Consideraciones sobre un caso de hemofilia, complicado con una manifestaci6n meningea. Sem. med, B. Air, 1935, 42: 670-4.—Jasienski, G. Sur un cas d'hematome perirenal spontan6 chez un hemophile. J. urol. med. Par, 1937, 44: 487-92.—Misuraca, S. Bron- corragie d'origine emofiliaca locale. Cult. med. mod. Pal, 1927, 6: 77-9.—Platou, E. S, & Platou, R. V. Hemophilia with intestinal obstruction. Minnesota M, 1940, 23: 857.— Roos, B. [Hemophilia with grave subcutaneous hemorrhages] Hygiea, Stockh, 1937, 99: 385-9.—Santi, M. Su un caso di emofilia renale. Rass. internaz. clin. ter, 1934, 15: 1245-9.— Tallroth, A. Hemophilia with spontaneous hemorrhage in the iliopsoas muscle followed by injury to the femoral nerve; report of a case. Acta chir. scand, 1939, 82: 1-10.—Traum, E. Ueber spontane Massenblutungen ins Nierenlager bei Hamo- philie, zugleich ein Beitrag zur ihrer Behandlung. Deut. Zschr. Chir, 1929, 215: 351-4.—Voit, K., & Paus, T. Todliche Blutung ins paratracheale Gewebe bei Hamophilie. Zschr. Hals &c. Heilk, 1932-33, 32: 473-5.—Weil, P. E. Les hema- turies des hemophiles; etude pathogenique. Presse med, 1940, 48:468. --- Site of hemorrhage: Bones, and joints. Lenner, J. *Die Gelenkbeteiligung bei Bluterkrankheit. 27p. 8? Erlangen, 1928. Odru-Trocm^, M. *Contribution a l'etude des accidents articulaires chez les hemophiles. 77p. 8! Par., 1935. Alquier. Un cas d'osteo-arthrite hemophilique bilaterale. Bull. Soc. radiol. med. France, 1936, 24: 604-7.—Bachmann. Das Blutergelenk im Rontgenogramm. Rontgenpraxis, 1929, 1: 724-31.—Bernstein, M. A. The treatment of joint lesions in hemophilia by means of whole blood from menstruating women. J. Bone Surg, 1932, 14: 659-62.—Caffey, J., & Schlesinger, E. R. Certain effects of hemophilia on the growing skeleton; some roentgenographic observations on overgrowth and dysgenesis of the epiphyses associated with chronic hemarthrosis. J. Pediat, S. Louis, 1940, 16: 549-65.— Canigiani, T. Gelenkverandcrungen bei Hamophilie. Ront- genpraxis, 1930, 2: 511-7.—Christmann, F. E, & Moreda, J. J. Artropatia hemofilica. Bol. Soc. cir. B. Aires, 1933, 17: 802-9. Also Rev. As. med. argent, 1933, 46: 3297-302 — Condamin, F. Arthrites hemophiliques chroniques. Lyon med, 1927, 139: 631-3.—Didiee, J. Un cas d'arthropathies multiples chez un hemophile. Bull. Soc. radiol. med. France, 1929, 17: 154-7.—Doric, L. [Diseases of articulations in hemo- philiacs] Cas. lek. Cesk, 1931, 70: 374-5, 5 pl.—Doub, H. P, & Davidson, E. C. Roentgen-ray examination of the joints of hemophilics. Radiology, 1926, 6: 217-27.—Firor, W. M, & Woodhall, B. Hemophilic pseudotumor: diagnosis, pathology and surgical treatment of hemophilic lesions in the smaller bones and joints. Bull. Johns Hopkins Hosp, 1936, 59: 237-50.—Fonio, A. Das Blutergelenk mit besonderer Be- riicksichtigung der Berner Bluter. Arch. klin. Chir, 1938, 191: 171-236.—Forfota, E. [Changes in joints and bones in hemophilia] Magy. rontg. kozl, 1931, 5: 1-13. Also Ront- genpraxis, 1931, 3: 399-406.—Freund, E. Haemarthros ex haemophilia. Wien. med. Wschr, 1928, 78: 583.—Gucci, G. Contributo alio studio delle artropatie emofiliache. Poli- clinico, 1933, 40: sez. med, 462-74.—Guglielmini, T. Le artropatie emofiliache. Med. prat. Nap, 1930, 15: 41-7.— Heigl, R. Rontgenbefunde bei Blutergelenken. Fortsch. Rontgenstrahl, 1929, 39: 107-10.—Holsti, H. Hamofili med ledg&ngsaffektioner. Fin. lak. sail, hand, 1909, 51: 840.— Jianu, A, Theodorescu, D, & Criveanu, C. iHemophilic arthropathy] Romania med, 1934, 12: 1-2.—Jurewicz, Z. [On articular changes in hemophilia] Chir. narz. ruchu, 1936, 9: 439-59, 3 pl.—Kahn, M. Hip joint changes in hemophilia. Radiology, 1934, 22: 286-8.—Kanekievich, M. I. [Affections of the joints caused by hemophilia] Ortop. travmat, 1939, 13: 55-60.—Keefer, C. S, & Myers, W. K. Hemophilic arthritis. N. England J. M, 1933, 208: 1183-9.—Key, J. A. Hemo- philic arthritis (bleeder's joints) Ann. Surg, 1932, 95: 198- 225.—L, J. Hemophilic avec arthropathie persistante; im- portance pratique du diagnostic etiologique de l'hemarthrose. Rev. g6n. clin. ther, 1934, 48: 503.—Le Marc'Hadour, A., & Breton, A. Les arthropathies hemophiliques. Echo med. nord, 1932, 36: 603-10. Also Paris med, 1932, 85: 497-504 — Lohr. Ueber Veranderungen im Hiiftgelenk bei Blutern; ein Beitrag zur Frage der Epiphysenstorungen der Schenkel- kopfepiphyse. Deut. Zschr. Chir, 1930, 228: 234-48 — Mauro, M. Le artriti emofiliache. Ann. ital. chir, 1934, 13: 571-618.—Michel, G, & Michel, L. Arthrite hemophilique. Rev. med. est, 1907, 39: 249-51.—Newcomer, N. B. The joint changes in hemophilia. Radiology, 1939, 32: 573-82.— Peracchia, G. Le artropatie emofiliache. Arch, ortop, Milano, 1932, 48: 43.3-82.—Prip Buus, C. E. Articular changes in hemophilia. Acta radiol, Stockh, 1935, 16: 503-17, 4 pl.— Solis-Cohen, L, & Levine, S. Bone and joint changes in hemophilia. Am. J. Roentg, 1934, 31: 487-91.—Thomas, H. B. Some orthopaedic findings in 98 cases of hemophilia. J. Bone Surg, 1936, 18: 140-7.—Vega, M. N, & Bosco, J. J. Breves consideraciones sobre un caso de hemofilia: artritis hemofilica. Rev. med. Rosario, 1926, 16: 45-50.—Weil, P. E. Traitement des hemarthroses hemophiliques. J. med. chir Par 1930, 101: 457-62. ------ Les arthropathies hemo- philiques; le rhumatisme hematique. Bull. Soc. med. hop. Paris, 1931, 3. ser, 47: 1605-8. ------ & Massart, R. Les arthropathies des hemophiles. Rev. chir. Par, 1931, 69: 199-228.—Wilson, M. G. A classical case of hemophilic arthritis. Am. J. Dis. Child, 1919, 18: 127-32. Also repr. ---- sporadic. Montanus, E. *Ueber einen Fall von spora- discher Hamophilie. 21p. 8? Basel, 1921. Also Schweiz. med. Wschr, 1921, 51: Danzer, R. Klinische Beobachtungen an einem Fall von sporadischer Hamophilie. Jahrb. Kinderh, 1937, 3. F, 100: 65-90. Also Ausz. Inaugur. Diss. Med. Fak. Univ. Bern (1935-37) 1938, No. 19i, 1-4.—Ferrannini, L. Emofilia sporadica. Minerva med. Tor, 1935, 26: pt 2, 129-33.— Laclette, R. Contribuicao ao estudo clinico e therapeutico da hemophilia esporadica. Arch, brasil. med, Rio, 1932, 22: 367; passim.—Marr, W. L, & Herrmann, G. Sporadic hemo- philia with especial reference to successful therapy. Texas J. M, 1934, 30:494-8. ---- Surgical aspect. Depardieu, R. *Quelques observations d'in- terventions chirurgicales chez les hemophiles. 105p. 8? Par., 1936. Wollmann, K. G. *Lokale Wundbehandlung bei Blutern. 28p. 8? Marburg-Lahn, 1935. Fauquez. Hemophilic et accident de travail. Ann. med. leg, 1927, 7: 237-41.—Friedrich, H. Ueber das Operations- risiko bei Hamophilen. Chirurg, 1935, 7: 73-8.—Giannantoni, C. L'emofilia in oftalmologia. Ann. ottalm, 1927, 55: 642-6.— Madlener, M. Hamophiliefragen. Zbl. Chir, 1928, 55: 1667.—Mariau, A. Hemorragie grave post-operatoire chez un hemophile meconnu; gu6rison par l'anthema. Biol, med. Par, 1923, 13: 400.—Molina Gijen, J. Hemofilia y cirugia. Med. ibera, 1934, 28: pt 2, 656-9.—Tavernier. Operation chez les hemophiles. Lyon chir, 1938, 35: 688-90.—Vance, C. A. Surgery in hemophilia; report of 4 cases. Tr. South. Surg. Ass, 1938, 51: 233-41. Also Ann. Surg, 1939, 109: 872-80.—Weil, P. E. Les interventions chirurgicales chez les hemophiles. Presse med, 1931, 39: 1021-4. ------ & Scemama. Grande hemorragie post-operatoire chez un hemo- phile; guerisons aprSs 25 transfusions: 12 litres de sang. Sang, Par, 1936, 10: 525.—Welcker, E. R. Hamophilie und Un- fallverletzung. Mschr. Unfallh, 1935, 42: 593-604. ---- Treatment. Deutschmann [G.] H. *Ueber Hamophilie und ihre Behandlung. 8p. 8? [Lpz.] 1923. Llopis, F. Hamophilie und ihre Behandlung (wissenschaftliche Grundlagen) 95p. 4 pl. 8? Lpz., 1929. Bardhan, P. N. On the treatment of haemophilia. Malav. M. J, 1937, 12: 93.—Behandlung (Die) der Blutungsubel. Aerztl. Prax, Wien, 1935, 9: 265-7.—Bertrand-Fontaine, T, & L'Hirondel, J. Etat actuel du traitement de l'hemophilie. Bull. gen. ther, 1936, 187: 425-40.—Christie, R. V, & Gulland, G. L. Studies in blood coagulation and haemophilia; the treatment of haemophilia. Q. J. Med, Oxf, 1926-27, 20: 499-510.—Doan, C. A. Hemophilia. In Modern Med. Ther. (Barr, D. P.) Bait, 1940, 3: 2981-4.—Domarus, A. von. Fortschritte in der Behandlung der Hamophilie und verwandter Zustande. Fortsch. Ther, 1932, 8: 641-8. Also Rev. med. germ. iber. amer, 1933, 6: 369-76.—Eley, R. C. The treat- ment of hemophilia. In Pract. Libr. M. & S. (Appleton) N. Y, 1940, Suppl, 647-51.—Jones, H. W., & Tocantins, L. M. The treatment of hemophilia. J. Am. M. Ass, 1934, 103: 1671-8.—Lehndorff, H. Zur Prognose und Behandlung der Blutungsubel. Aerztl. Prax, Wien, 1935, 9: 159-61.— Macfarlane, R. G. The treatment of haemophilie haemorrhage. S. Barth. Hosp. Rep, Lond, 1935, 68: 229-54.—McGavack, T. H. Some recent advances in the treatment of hemophilia. Med. Clin. N. America, 1940, 24: 791-805.—Santesson, C. G. [Treatment of hemophilia] Sven. lak. tidn, 1938, 35: 2126-8 — Stancanelli, G. Terapia deU'emofilia. Pediatria (Riv.) 1933, 41: 939-45.—Tratamiento de la hemofilia. Dia med, B. Air, 1935, 7: 1394. ---- Treatment: Acute attack. Baker, G. A, & Gibson, P. C. A case of haemophilia treated with Russell viper venom. Lancet, Lond, 1936, 1: 428.— Clement, F. Hemophilic et muscle d'oiseau. Bull. Soc. chir. Paris, 1931, 23: 304-9.—Costa Staricco, G. B. L'emostasi della emorragia emofilica con irradiazioni Rontgen della milza e del iegato associate ad autoemoterapia. Pediatria (Riv.) 1933, 41: 1164-70.—Dickey, L. B. Tissue fibrinogen by mouth in the treatment of acute hemorrhage in hemophilia. Med. J. & Rec, 1926, 124: 543.—Eley, R. C. Hemophilia: the anaphylactic treatment of acute emergencies by passive sensitization; report of a case. N. England J. M, 1932, 206: 227475—VOL. 7, 4th series----34 HEMOPHILIA 530 HEMOPHILIA 998.— Fbnt, W. R. Mechanical arrest of hemorrhage in a case of hemophilia. Internat. J. Orthodont, 1930, 16: 1093 — Haemostasia in haemophilia. Lancet, Lond, 1935, 2: 893.— Kaufmann, E. Xatriumcitrat bei Hamophilie. Klin. Wschr., 1931, 13: 179.—Kocsis, A. Neues Verfahren zur StiUung der Blutung bei Hamophilie. Verh. ungar. arztl. Ges, 1934, 6: 85.—Krauss. H. Beitrag zur Blutstillung bei Hamophilen mit Vivocoll. Med. Korbl. Wurttemberg, 1927, 97: 214 — Kreiner, W. M. Natriunrcitrat-Anweiidung bei Hamophilie. Klin. Wschr, 1933,12:1900 -8. —Mariani, R. La cura dell'emo- filia e il muscolo di uccello. Umbria med., 1931, 11: 2008.— Payne, W. W, & Steen, R. E. Haemostatic therapy in haemo- philia. Brit. M. J, 1929, 1: 1150-2. Also Irish J. M. Sc, 1929, 6. ser, 718-25, 4 ch.—Sack. G. Ueber die hamostyp- tische Wirkung der Pektine, insbesondere bei Hamophilie. Klin. Wschr, 1935, 14: 1536-8.—Smith, H. P, Ziffren, S. E. [et al.] The jaundiced bleeder; control of hemorrhage through vitamin K therapy. J. Iowa M. Soc, 1939, 29: 377-84.— Trauner, F. Blutungsbereitschaft und Blutstillung bei Hamo- philen. Zschr. Stomat, 1937, 35: 276-80.—Vogel, R. Ueber die Blutstillung bei Hamophilie. Zbl. Chir, 1929, 56: 1807-10. ---- Treatment, endocrine. Storch, E. *L'hormonotherapie ovarienne dans l'hemophilie familiale. 38p. 8? Par., 1935. Alfano, A. L'ormone follicolare nella cura della emofilia. Ann. med. nav, Roma, 1938, 44: 461-6.—Battignani, C. La cura dell'emofilia coll'ormone ovarico. Riv. clin. med, 1933, 34: 236-50.—Brem, J, & Leopold, J. S. Ovarian therapy; relationship of the female sex hormone to hemophilia. J. Am. M. Ass, 1934,102:200-2. Also repr.—Brown, R. L, & Albright, F. Estrin therapv in a case of hemophilia. N. England J. M, 1933, 209: 630-2.—Chew, W. B., Stetson, R. P. [et al.] Estro- genic, luteal and gonadotropic hormones in hemophilia. Arch. Int. M, 1935, 55: 431-44.—De Silva, E. B. Treatment of hemorrhage in hemophiliacs and nonhemophiliacs with theelin in oil. Illinois M. J, 1936, 69: 81-3.—Enderlen, E. Zu der Mitteilung iiber die Beeinflussbarkeit der Hamophilie durch Ovarialhormone von Harald von Samson-Himmelstjerna, Katharinen (Kadrina) Estland. Zbl. Chir, 1933, 60: 2021.— Foord, A. G, & Dysart, B. R. Treatment of hemophilia by an ovarian extract by Birch's method. J. Am. M. Ass, 1932, 98: 1444. Also repr.—Franke, K, & Litzner, S. Lebensrettende Wirkung von Ovarienpraparaten bei schweren Blutungen eines Hamophilen. Med. Klin, Berl, 1935, 31: 520.—Gissel, H. Ueber die Behandlung der Hamophilie mit A. T. 10. Arch. khn. Chir, 1934, 180: 647 [Discussion] 29. Also Zbl. Chir, 1934, 61: 2488.—Goldstein, H. I. Ovarian grafts, ovarian extract and female sex hormones in the treatment of hemo- philia. Med. Rev. of Rev, 1933, 39: 329-33.—Gonalons, G. P. El tratamiento de la hemofilia por la opoterapia ovArica; sus fundamentos. Prensa med. argent, 1933-34, 20: 2306-8.— Hormones in the treatment of hemophilia. J. Am. M. Ass, 1935. 104: 1422.—Kimm, H. T., & Van Allen, C. M. Hemo- philia: prevention and treatment of bleeding with ovarian extract. Ibid, 1932, 99: 991.—Kocsis, A. G. [Treatment of hemophilia with female sex hormon] Gy6gydszat, 1934, 74: 477-9.—Kup, J. von. Erfolgreiche Behandlung der Hamo- philie mit einem Hormon des Corpus luteum. Frankf. Zschr. Path, 1938, 52: 590-6.—Petresco, M., & Vanesco, E. Le traitement par la folliculine de la grande hemophihe familiale. Bull. Acad. med. Roumanie, 1936, 1: 366-8.—Pfenninger, H. Zur Behandlung der Hamophilie mit A. T. 10. Deut. Zschr. Chir, 1934-35, 244: 242-4.—Ravina, A. Le traitement de l'hemophilie par l'extrait ovarien. Presse med, 1933, 41: 315-7.—Samson-Himmelstjerna, H. von. Ueber die Beein- flussbarkeit der Hamophile durch Ovarialhormone. Zbl. Chir, 1933, 60: 1462.—Schiavo, E. Sulla terapia ovarica dell'emo- filia. Policlinico, 1934, 41: sez. prat, 1881-9.—S01toft-Jensen, M. [Folliculin in hemorrhages in hemophilia] Ugeskr. laeger, 1934, 96: 625.—Spoto, J. S. Treatment of hemophilia with ovarian extract; report of 2 cases. J. Florida M. Ass, 1933, 20: 9-13.—Spolo, P., & Cantone, D. Consideracoes sobre o trata- mento ovariano da hemofilia. Resenha clin. cient, S. Paulo 1940, 9: 225-34.—Stetson, R. P., Forkner, C. E. [et al.] Nega- tive effect of prolonged administration of ovarian substances in hemophilia. J. Am. M. Ass, 1934, 102: 1122-6.—Tureen, L. L. Note on ineffective use of theelin in a case of hemophilia. Am. J. M. Sc, 1934, 188: 216-9.—White, C. E. Treatment of hemophilia with theelin. J. Oklahoma M. Ass, 1932, 25: 304. ---- Treatment, histological. Bendien, W. M, & CreveW, S. van. Investigations on haemophilia; further experiments with extracts from the human placenta. Acta brevia neerl, 1938, 8: 136-9.—Beren- stein, V. S. [Hemostatic effect of blood transfusion in hemo- philia] Kazan, med. J, 1939, 35: No. 4, 35-7.—Bertoye, Brunat & Rochet. Accidents hemorragiques graves chez un hemophile, familial arrete par l'hemotherapie maternelle. Lyon med 1928. 141: 128-30.—Chevallier, P., Colin, M., & Moline, R. Un cas d'hypohemophilie essentielle; traitement par l'extrait de plaquettes. Sang, Par, 1935, 9: 332-4.—Courty, L., & Buisine, A. La transfusion du sang dans l'hemophilie. J. sc. med. Lille, 1925, 43: 89-95.—Drummond, H. Haemophilia, treated by blood transfusion. Newcastle M. J., 1924-25, 5: 44.— East, T. Hemophilia treated by liver extract. Proc. R. Soc M, Lond, 1929-30, 23: Sect. Clin, 31.—Eley, R. 0., & Cfifionh S. H. Hemophilia; treatment bv protein sensitization. Am ,| Dis. Child, 1931, 42: 1331 -8. Also repr.—Eley. R. C, Green] A. A, & McKhann, C. F. Blood coagulants from placental extracts; effect in hemophilia. Ibid, 1935, 50:1320-8. ---- The use of a blood coagulant extract from the human placentn in the treat incut of hemophilia. J. Pediat, S. Louis, 1936, 8: 135-47.—Fonio, A. Zentralstelle fiir unentgcltliche Coagulen- Abgabe an bediirftige Hamophile. Schweiz. med. Wschr, 1941, 71: 108.—Houda, E. O. Serum treatment of mendeliau hemophilia. Clin. M. & S, 1933, 40: 209.—Johnson, J. B. The management of hemophilia, with lyophile human plasma intravenously injected. J. Am. M. Ass, 1942, 118: 799-802.— Jost, V. I, & Gotovkina, V. C. [Transfusion of blood in hemo- philia] Klin. J. Saratov, 1929, 8: 237-44—Kaganovich-Dvor- kin, A. L. [Blood transfusion in treatment of hemophilia; cat?o report] Sovet. med, 1939, 43.—Kohl, H. Histidinbehandlung der Hamophilie. Zschr. klin. Med, 1937, 132: 40-54.— Life-saver for bleeders found—in egg white. Science News Lett, 193G, 30: 375.—Marlow, A. The negative effect of the administration of liver in hemophilia. Bull. Johns Hopkins Hosp, 1931, 49: 49-54.—Peck, S. M, Crimmins, M. L, & Erf, L. A. Coagulating power of Bothrops atrox venom on hemophiliac blood. Proc. Soc. Exp. Biol, N. Y, 1934-35, 32: 1525-7.—Pohle, F. J., & Taylor, F. H. I, The use of a globulin substance derived from beef plasma as a local hemostatic in hemophilia. J. Clin. Invest, 1938, 17: 677-82. Also repr.— Rosenblum, M. B, & Malkina, M. G. [Successful serotherapy in hemophilia] Klin. med. Moskva, 1930, 8: 1040-4.—Taege, K. Hamophilie und Giinseblut. Miinch. med. Wschr, 1929, 76: 714.—Thrombin treatment promises to save lives of bleeders; tried out under extreme conditions on animals, blood-clotting substance stops hemorrhages. Science News Lett, 1939, 35: 83.—Tocantins, L. M. Effets de l'injection du s6rum anti- plaquettes k 3 sujets hemophiles et k un sujet normal; action de divers serums sur le sang in vitro. Sang, Par, 1936, 10: 582- 91. Also repr.—Tyson, T. L, & West, R. Effect of trypsin on the clotting of the blood in hemophilia. Proc. Soc. Exp. Biol, N. Y, 1937-38, 36: 494-6.—Weil, P. E. Accidents hemophili- ques graves (hematome retro-orbitaire, hematome du plancher buccal) arreted par la transfusion du sang. Bull. Soc. med. hop. Paris, 1929, 3. ser., 53: 187-9. ---- Treatment: Methods. Havet, J. *L'hemophilie et son traitement par les vitamines. 44p. 8? Par., 1937. Jakob, H. *Ueber die Nateinabehandlung der Hamophilie. 29p. 8? Heidelb., 1933. Bj0rn-Hansen, H. [Treatment of hemophilia with the vitamin preparation natcina (Llopis)] Norsk mag. lsegevid, 1930, 91: 1372-84.—Dimmel, H. Zur Therapie hamophiler Blutungen. Med. Klin, Berl, 1931, 27: 92.—Driels, A. Zur Nateinabehandlung der Hamophilie. Deut. med. Wschr, 1930, 56: 10.—Elosegui, C. Vitamine und Hamophilie. Ther. Gegenwart, 1935, 76: 359-63.—Falkenhausen, von. Fort- schritte in der Behandlung der Hamophilie. Fortsch. Ther, 1930, 6: 641-4.—Gonzalez Delcito, F. Hemofilia y vitaminas. Siglo med, 1935, 96: 65.—Grassi, M. Tentativi terapeutici col rosso congo in un caso di emofilia. Pediatria (Riv.) 1938, 46: 1057-63.—Hajos, K. [C vitamin in treatment of hemo- philia] Orv. hetil, 1935, 79: mell, 93.—Harreveld, A. van [Vitamin D content of nateina] Ned. tschr. geneesk, 1930, 74: pt 2, 4219.—Johnson, J. B. Effect of oxalic acid given intra- venously on the coagulation time in hemophilia. Proc. Soc. Exp. Biol, N. Y, 1941, 46: 496-9.—Klemperer, F. Zum Problem der Hamophilie und ihrer Behandlung mit Nateina- Llopis. Ther. Gegenwart, 1932, 73: 182-4.—Klinke, K. Nateinabehandlung bei Blutungsleiden. Jahrb. Kinderh, 1931, 3. F, 83: 1-11.—Kortzeborn. Nateina-Behandlung und chirurgische Indikationsstellung bei der Hamophilie. Chirurg, 1930, 2: 641-4.—Lawson, G. B., Jackson, W. P., & Gardner, J. E. A case of hemophilia treated by venesection. J. Am. M. Ass, 1932, 98: 1443.—Lawson, G. B., & Graybeal, A. B. Hemophilia treated by venesection. Ibid, 1938, 111: 2104; 1940, 114: 2299.—Llopis Lopez, F. Vitaminas y hemofilia; nuevas aportaciones. Arch, med, Madr, 1927, 26: 474-81.— New remedies for haemophilia. Lancet, Lond, 1936, 2:1219.— Niehans, P. Vorlaufige Mitteilung zur Behandlung der Hamophilie. Schweiz. med. Wschr, 1930, 60: 18.—Niekau, B. Hamophilie und ihre erfolgreiche Behandlung mit Nateina Llopis. KUn. Wschr, 1928, 7: 590-4. Also Progr. clin, Madr, 1928, 36: 295-302. ------ Zur Behandlung der Hamophilie. Zschr. arztl. Fortbild, 1929, 26: 1-4. ------ Drei Jahre erfolgreicher Hamophiliebehandlung mit Nateina-LIopis. Verh Deut. Ges. inn. Med, 1930, 42. Kongr, 529-36.—Page, R. C Russell, H. K., & Rosenthal, R. L. Effect of oxalic acid intra- venously on blood-coagulation time in 3 hemophiliacs. Ann. Int. M, 1940-41, 14: 78-86.—Pittaluga, G, & Elosegui, C. Nuevas observaciones sobre la acci6n de las vitaminas en la hemofilia. Arch, med, Madr, 1927, 26: 405-12.—Schrader. Zur Nateinabehandlung der Hamophilie. Miinch. med Wschr, 1932, 79: 223.—Schrader, E. Heilung der Bluter- krankheit? Umschau, 1928, 32: 1081.—Stormer, A. Zur- Therapie der Hemophilie. Ther. Gegenwart, 1937, 78: 535- 9.—Timperley, W. A., Naish, A. E.. & Clark, G. A. A new HEMOPHILIA 531 HEMOPHILUS method of treatment in haemophilia. Lancet, Lond, 1936, 2: 1142-9.—Trauner, F. Zur Therapie der Haemophilie. Wien. klin. Wschr, 1927, 40: 24-6.—Van Buran, E. The use of oxalic acid in the treatment of hemophilia. Bull. Fulton Co. M. Soc, 1942, 16: No. 5, 11.—Vaughan, S. L. Two cases of haemophilia treated by the oral administration of cephalin. Bull. Buffalo Gen. Hosp, 1927, 5: 17.—Waldorp, C. P, & Alvarez, A. G. Tratamiento de la hemofilia; ensayo de la action del rojo-congo; interpretation de sus resultados. Actas Congr. nac. med, Rosario, 1934, 5: pt 4, 220-7. Also Sem. med, B. Air, 1935, 42: 6-11.—Weil, P. E. Remarques clini- ques et therapeutiques sur les hemorragies hemophiliques. Presse med, 1929, 37: 266—Wdrner, A. Zur Behandlung der Hamophilie. Miinch. med. Wschr, 1931, 78: 664.—Ziegelroth, P. Zur diatetischen Therapie der Hamophilie. Ibid, 1928, 75: 133. ---- in animals. Bogart, R, & Muhrer, M. E. The inheritance of a hemo- philia-like condition in swine. J. Hered, 1942, 33: 59-64. -----■ & Hogan, A. G. The physiology and inheritance of a hemophilia-like abnormality in swine. Genetics, 1942, 27: 133. ------ A hemophilia-like disease in swine. Proc. Soc. Exp. Biol, N. Y, 1941, 48: 217-9.—Chapron, H. Hemophile apres castration chez le cheval. Rec. med. vet, 1927, 103: 879-84.—Griffith, F. R, jr, & Friedman, B. Hemophilia in cats after denervation of the liver. Proc. Soc Exp. Biol, N. Y, 1926-27, 24: 64.—McKinna. W. R. Haemophilia. Vet. J, Lond, 1936, 92: 370.—Noell. Traitement d'un cas d'hemo- philie chez un chien. Rec. med. vet, 1932, 108: 356.—The- venoz, L. Deux cas d'hematomes chez la vache (probabilite d'hemophilie) Schweiz. Arch. Tierh, 1935, 77: 31-3. HEMOPHILUS. See also Hemophileae. Anderson, L. R. A study of bacilli of the genus Hemophilus with regard to the X- and V-growth factors under aerobic and anaerobic conditions. Am. J. Hyg, 1931, 13: 164-200.— Assis, A. de. Observacoes sobre particularidades biologicas dos estreptobacillos do genero Hemophilus class, amer. Sciencia med, Rio, 1927, 5: 61-8. ------ Estudos immunologicos sobre os estreptobacillos do genero Hemophilus, Comm. Amer. 1917. Ibid, 133-44.—Bass, A, Berkman, S. [et al.] Growth factors for Hemophilus influenzae and Hemophilus parain- fluenzae. J. Infect. Dis, 1941, 68:175-83.—Dechigi.M. Come si isola l'emofilo pertossico di Bordet-Gengou e come lo si differenzia dall'emofilo influenzale di Pfeiffer. Diagn. teen. lab. Nap, 1936, 7: 411-5.—Grekowitz, G. Ueber ein gram- negatives Stabchen aus der Gruppe der hamoglobinophilen Bakterien (Bacterium haemophilum mucosum) Zbl. Bakt, 1. Abt, 1929, 112: 143-51, pl.—Gundel, M., & Schluter, W. Zur Frage der Differenzierung zwischen Keuchhusten- und In- fluenzabacillen. Klin. Wschr, 1933, 12: 912. ------ Experi- mentelle Untersuchungen iiber den Keuchhustenbazillus (Bacillus Bordet-Gengou) seine Diagnose und die Differential- diagnose gegeniiber Influenzabazillen. Zbl. Bakt, 1. Abt, 1933, 129: 461-89, 2 pl.—Kairies, A, & Tartler, G. Die Brauchbarkeit der Kochblutagarplatte zum Nachweis von Pasteurellen bei Hasen und Kaninchen; mit einem Beitrag iiber allgemeine und obligate Hamoglobinophilie bakterieller In- fluenzaerreger. Ibid, 1937-38, 140: 36-47.—Kanauchi, S. Immunologische Studien iiber Keuchhusten- und Influenza- bazillen; iiber die negative Phase der Agglutination, die Ge- schwindigkeit und den Grad der Agglutininproduktion infolge intravenoser Applikation der Influenzavakzine. Acta derm, Kyoto, 1936, 27: 76.—Kasahara, M. Beitrag zur Frage der Differenzierung zwischen Keuchhusten- und Influenzabacillen. KUn. Wschr, 1933, 12: 1609-11.—Kleinschmidt, H. Der Bordet-Gengousche Keuchhustenbacillus und der Pfeiffersche Influenzabacillus. Ibid, 1931, 10:1847-50.—Lodenkamper,H. Zur Biologie des Keuchhusten- und Influenzabazillus. Zbl. Bakt, 1. Abt, 1936, 137: 131-42.—Lwoff, A. La fonction de la protohemine pour les protozoaires et les bacteries parahemo- trophes. C. rend. Soc. biol, 1936, 122: 1041.—Silverthorne, N. The development of antibodies in the blood of rabbits by injec- tion of freshly isolated strains of H. influenzae type B and phase I H. pertussis. Canad. Pub. Health J, 1940, 31: 560.— Steigler, A. Beitrag zur Unterscheidung von Keuchhusten- bacillen und Influenzabacillen. Klin. Wschr, 1938, 17:1480. ---- ducreyi. See Chancroid, Bacteriology. ---- duplex [Moraxella] See also Conjunctivitis, diplobacillary. Chaine, R. *Le diplobacille de Morax et le diplobacille liquefiant de Petit (etude comparee) 82p. 8? Par., 1914. Constas. Recherches sur la vitalite du diplobacille de Morax dans l'eau. Ann. ocul. Par, 1925, 162: 201-3.—Coppez, L. Contribution k l'etude du diplobacille de Morax. Ibid, 655- 60.—Cottini, G. B., & Mezzadra, G. Curioso comportamento del bacillo di Morax-Axenfeld inoculato nei cervello di topino e su membrana corion-allantoidea di embrione di polio. Arch. A^L^ SPTa *?f9' 4:u1001-8.-Lwofr, A. Revision et demembrement des Hemophileae; le genre Moraxella nov gen Ann. Inst. Pasteur, Par, 1939, 62: 168-76.—McKee, S. h! lne cultivation in pure culture, of the diplobacillus of Morax- VkXe ™d,aHa!?mophilus duplex, Bergey. Am. J. Ophth, 1942, L i • oral' L infection diplobacillaire. Bull. Soc opht. Pans, 1932, 100-6. ---- gallinarum. See under Coryza [of fowl] ---- influenzae [Koch-Weeks; Pfeiffer] See also Influenza, Bacteriology. Bakos, M. [Investigations of the properties of Bacillus influenzae with special reference to Pfeiffer's Bacillus influenzael Allatorv. lap, 1936, 59: 109-15.—Dingle, J. H, & FothergiH, L. U. 1 he isolation and properties of the specific polysaccharide of type B Hemophilus influenzae. J. Immun, Bait, 1939 37- ?3;t3' ~TT,— & Chandler, C. A. The pattern of dissociation in Hemophilus influenzae. J. Bact, Bait, 1939, 37: 415-27 — Dujarric de la Riviere, R. Sur la filtrabilite du bacille de Pfeiffer. Zbl. Bakt, Z. I. Abt, 1928,106:30.—Durand, P, & Lumbroso, U. Recherches sur le bacille de Weeks. Arch Inst Pasteur Tunis, 1926, 15: 71-92. ------ Quelques caracteres du bacille de Weeks; ses rapports avec le bacille de Pfeiffer C. rend. Soc. biol, 1926, 94: 1322.—Evans, M. J. A study of Hemophilus influenzae. Am. J. M. Sc, 1930, 179: 177-92 Also repr.—Fenyvessy, B, & Kun, L. [Variability of Bacillus influenzae] Magy. orv. arch, 1931, 32: 341-54, 2 pl.—Finster- waSder, C. Untersuchungen iiber Koch-Weeksche Bazillen Arch. Hyg, Berl, 1928, 100: 5-8. Also repr—Gilbert, R. Influenza bacilli. Annual Rep. Div. Lab. N. York State Dep Health, 1940, 48.—Holster, S. G. The microbic dissociation of Hemophilus influenzae. Yale J. Biol, 1930-31, 3: 321-40, 2 pl.—Knorr, M. Das Koch-Weekssche Bacterium und der Pfeiffersche Influenzabacillus. Erg. Hyg, 1924, 6: 350-96. Untersuchungen iiber den Erreger der agyptischeri Augenentzundung (Koch-Weekssches Bakterium) und seine Beziehungen zum Pfeifferschen Influenzabazillus. Zbl. Bakt l.Abt, 1924, 92: Orig, 371-84. ------ Weitere Untersuchun- gen iiber die Wirkung von Korperfliissigkeiten und Adsorbentien auf die wachstumsfordernden Stoffe der roten Bluktorperchen Ibid, 1925, 94: Orig, 161-5. ------ Arbeiten uber Koch- Weeks- und Influenzabazillen. Deut. med. Wschr, 1925, 51: 65.—Kobe, K. Unterscheidung der Influenzabakterien von den Pasteurellen. Zbl. Bakt, 1. Abt, 1936-37, 138: 158-63.— Pesch, K. Vergleichende Untersuchungen iiber den Erreger der Koch-Weeksschen Konjunktivitis und das Pfeiffersche In- fluenzastabehen. Miinch. med. Wschr, 1921, 68: 390.— Pittman, M. Variation and type specificity in the bacterial species Hemophilus influenzae. J. Exp. M, 1931, 53: 471-92, pl. Also repr.—Wilkes-Weiss, D. A comparison of meningeal and other strains of H. influenzae. J. Infect. Dis, 1937, 60: 213-22. ---- influenzae: Culture. Eirund, A. *Ueber die anaerobe Ziichtung des Bazillus influenzae (Pfeiffer) p. 195-206. 8? Bresl., 1929. Also Zbl. Bakt, 1. Abt, 1929, 111: Petran, G. *Versuche zur Ziichtung des Bacillus influenzae (Baz. Pfeiffer) auf synthe- tischen Nahrboden [Breslau] p.29-38. 8? [Jena] 1927. Also Zbl. Bakt, 1. Abt, 1927, 103: Schwarz, K. *Die Verwertbarkeit der Amino- saurcn durch Influenza-Bakterien. 16p. 8° [Berl., 1935] Ali, M. Aegypticus (Koch-Weeks' bacillus) its cultural characters and morphology. J. R. Micr. Soc, Lond, 1926, 46: 112-22, 2 pl.—Bauer, E. N. [Simplification of the technique of isolation and preservation of Pfeiffer's B.) J. epidem. mikrob, Moskva, 1933, 2: 72-4.—Bernhof, F. G, Grudinsaka, E. G, & Savateev, A. I. [Field's medium for culture of Haemophilus influenzae] Vest, mikrob, 1936, 15: 450-5.—Durand, P. Milieux de culture pour le bacille de Weeks. C. rend. Soc. biol, 1924, 90: 77-9.—Kishino, S. On the growth of the Pfeiffer's influenza bacilli. Sc. Rep. Inst. Infect. Dis, Tokyo, 1926, 5: 127-50, pl.—Knorr, M, & Gehlen, W. Untersuchungen fiber einen Erreger der agyptischen Augenentzundung (Koch- Weekssches Bakterium) und seine Beziehungen zum Pfeiffer- schen Influenzabazillus; das Wachstum der hamophilen Keime in pflanzlichen Nahrmitteln. Zbl. Bakt, 1. Abt, 1925, 95: Orig, 295-311.—Kopp, H. Ueber das Verhalten des Influenza- bazillus in anaeroben Kulturen unter besonderer Beriicksichti- gung der X- und V-Faktoren. Ibid, 1927-28, 105: 54-6. Also Magy. orv. arch, 1928, 29: 52-5.—Lwoff, A., & Lwoff, M. La fonction de l'hemine, facteur de croissance pour Hemophilus influenzae. C. rend. Acad, sc, 1937, 204:1510-2.—Pittman, M. The interrelation of the amount of V-factor and the amount of air necessary for growth of Hemophilus influenzae Type B in certain media. J. Bact, Bait, 1935, 30: 149-61.—Rosher, A. HEMOPHILUS 532 HEMOPHILUS B. The effect of the X and V growth-factors on the patho- genicity of indole-producing strains of influenza bacilli. Brit. J. Exp. Path, 1931, 12: 133-ti—Schoenbach, E. B, & Seid- man. L. R. A selective medium for isolation of Hemophilus influenzae. Proc Soc. Exp. Biol, N. Y, 1942, 49: 108-10.— Smith, M. M. Observations on bacillus (Haemophilus) influenzae with special reference to morphology and colonial characters. J. Hyg, Lond, 1931, 31: 321-35, 2 pl. ---- influenzae: Pathogenicity. See also Bronchitis; Conjunctivitis, acute catarrhal; Influenza, Pathology; Pneumonia, &c. Preuss, M. *Epidemiologische und morpho- logische Influenzabazillenstudien aus dem Ende der letzten Pandemie. 28p. 8? Bresl., 1926. Bourn, J. M. Incidence of Pfeiffer's bacillus in throats dur- ing epidemic and interepidemic periods in Chicago. J. Prev. M, 1928, 2: 441-60. ------ Hemophilus influenzae in upper respiratory disease and in health, 1928-30. Am. J. Hyg, 1932, 15: 64-79.—Fenyvessy, B., & Hubany, O. [Role of Pfeiffer's bacillus in various diseasesl Orv. hetil, 1930, 74: 205-8.— Fleming, A, & MacLean, 1. H. On the occurrence of influenza bacilli in the mouths of normal people. Brit. J. Exp. Path, 1929-30, 11: 127-34.—Fothergill, L. D, Dingle, J. H, & Chandler, C. A. Studies on Haemophilus influenzae; infection of mice with mucin suspensions of the organism. J. Exp. M, 1937, 65:721-34. —■---- A comparative study of the virulence of smooth, rough, and respiratory strains of Haemophilus influenzae as determined by infection of mice with mucin suspensions of the organism. Ibid, 66: 789-99. Also repr. -----■ The survival of virulent H. influenzae in phagocytes. J. Immun, Bait, 1937, 32: 335-9.—Hirsch, W. Influenza- bazillen in periurethraler Zyste. Zbl. Bakt, 1. Abt, 1932, 124: 197.—Hoyle, L. A method of raising and maintaining the virulence of influenza bacilli, with some observations on the pathogenic properties of virulent strains. J. Path. Bact, Cambr, 1934, 39: 681-7, pl.—Huntington, R. W, jr. On the behavior of Hemophilus influenzae in certain diseases of children. J. CUn. Invest, 1935, 14: 459-64.—Kairies, A. Versuche zur Frage der Tierpathogenitat des Pfeifferschen Influenzabazillus. Zbl. Bakt, 1. Abt, 1932, 126:220-30. ------ Beobachtungen an Influenza-Bazillentragern und Dauerausscheidern. Arch. Hyg, Munch, 1933, 111: 1-10.—Klieneberger, E. Die Typen in der Influenzabacillengruppe und ihre Verbreitung in der Nachepidemiezeit von Miirz bis September 1929. Zschr. Hyg, 1930, 111: 1-30.—Kiihn, E. Ueber die Bedeutung des In- fluenzabazillus als Entzundungs- und Eitererreger. Zbl. Bakt. 1. Abt, 1934, 131: 181-93.—Kun, L. On the incidence of atypioal forms of B. influenzae and the rise of diagnostic diffi- culties caused by it. Magy. orv. arch, 1935, 36: 377-82. ------ & Fenyvessy, B. Variabilitat des Pfeifferschen In- fluenzabazillus im Tierkorper und ihre epidemiologische Be- deutung. Zbl. Bakt, 1. Abt, 1932, 124: 485-96.—Lamont, J. A. Haemolytic influenza bacilli in acute respiratory infection. Canad. M. Ass, J. 1926, 16: 1447-54.— Leichtentritt, B. Klinisches und Epidemiologisches vom Pfeifferschen Influenza- bazillus. Zbl. Bakt, 1. Abt, 1928, 106:176-89.—Levinthal, W. Das Vorkommen des Pfeifferschen Influenzabacillus bei Gesunden. Zschr. Hyg, 1028, 109: 93-5.—Lieber, K. Unter- suchungen an Leichenmaterial uber das Vorkommen des Pfeifferschen Influenzabazillus mit besonderer Berucksichtigung epidemiefreier Zeiten. Zbl. Bakt, 1. Abt, 1928, 106: 190-4.— Lookeren Campagne, J. van [Haemophilus influenzae (type B) as cause of an infection of the respiratory tract] Mschr kindergeneesk, 1937, 7: 43-9.—Mote, J. R, & Fothergill, L. The effect of human strains of Hemophilus influenzae on in- fluenza virus infections of swine. J. Bact, Bait, 1940, 39: 55.—Mulder, J. Haemophilus influenzae (Pfeiffer) as an ubiquitous cause of common acute and chronical purulent bronchitis. Acta med. scand, 1938, 94: 98-140.—Ono, H, Umetani, H., & Kawamori, Y. The bacteriological examination of sputa from influenza as well as tuberculous patients in searching for Pfeiffer's Hemophilus influenzae. Kekkaku, 1937, 15: 18.—Pittman, M. The protection of mice against Hemo- philus influenzae (non-type-specific) with sulfapyridine Pub Health Rep, Wash, 1939, 54: 1769-75. Also repr.— Signa] A. II bacillo di Pfeiffer nella grippe endemica. Pediatria (Riv.) 1928, 36: 237-^9.—Smorodintseff, A. A., Drobyshev- skaya, A. I. [et al.] CUnical and laboratory investigation on volunteers infected with Pfeiffer's bacillus. Lancet, Lond 1936, 2: 1381-3.—Tesdal, M. Experimental encephalo-myel- opathy in rabbit following intravenous injection of a smooth form of Bacillus influenzae Pfeiffer, recovered from a patient with meningitis. Acta path, microb. scand, 1932, Supp. 11 191-202.—Teveli, Z. [Cutaneous inoculations with the bac- terium of influenza] Orvoskepzes, 1934, 24: nov. kiildnf (Hainiss Festschr) 126-8.—Waaler, E. [Two cases of infection by Pfeiffer s baciUus] Norsk, mag. laegevid, 1931 92- 715- 20 —Watjen J., & Wasmuht, K. Ueber das Vorkommen von Influenzabacillen in epidemiefreier Zeit am Laufenden Sektions- gut Wirend eines Jahres. Erg. Hyg. Bakt, 1939, 22: 138- 67.—Walker, J. E. Infection of laboratory worker with Bacillus influenzae. J. Infect. Dis, 1928, 43: 300; 385. Also repr.—Wells, J. R., & Dixon, E. Occurrence of Hemophilus influenzae in throats of polar eskimos. Proc. Soc. Exp. Biol, ---- influenzae: Toxins, and antibodies. Alexander, H. E., & Heidelberger, M. Chemical studies on bacterial agglutination; agglutinin and precipitin content of antisera to Haemophilus influenzae, type B. J. Exp. M, 1910, 71: 1-11. Also repr.—Dubos, R. J. A soluble toxin produced by Hemophilus influenzae. J. Bact, Bait, 1942, 43: 77.— lizuka, A. Weitere serologische Einteilung von Influenza- bazillen. Zschr. Immunforsch, 1938, 94:312-8.—Kritsrhewski, I. L„ & Kapusto, M. L. Ueber das Hiimolysin des B. influenzae Pfeiffer. Ibid, 1932-33, 77: 242-6.—Pittman, M. 'Ihr action of tvpe-specific Hemophilus influenzae antiserum. ,J Kxp M 1933, 58: 683-706. Also repr. ------& Goodner, K. Com- plement-fixation with the type-specific carbohydrate of Hemo- philus influenzae type B. J. Immun, Bait, 1935, 29: 239-57.__ Piatt, A. E. A serological study of Haemophilus influenzae J. Hyg, Cambr, 1937, 37: 98-107. Also Austral. J. Exp. Biol ' 1939, 17: 19-24.—Shigeno, K. Serologische Untersuchung influenzaahnlicher Bazillen aus verschiedenen chirurgischen Erkrankungen. Zschr. Immunforsch, 1935, 86: 80-3.__ Takebe, T. A study of the action of bacterial toxin upon the blood vessel with special reference to that of B. influenzae Kitasato Arch, 1935, 12: 58-81.—Ward, H. K. A note on a light-activated hemolysin produced by B. influenzae. J. Bact. Bait, 1928, 15: 51-4.—Yagi, A. Immunisatorische Einteilung der Influenzabazillen. Zschr. Immunforsch, 1935, 86: 75-9. ---- influenzae murium. Ivanovics, G, & Ivanovics, C. Beitrage zur Kenntnis des Bacterium influenzae murium (Kairies und Schwartzer) Zbl Bakt, 1. Abt, 1937, 139: 184-8.—Kairies, A, & Schwartzer, K. Studien zu einer bakteriellen Influenza der Miiuse und Beschrei- bung eines Bacterium influenzae murium. Ibid.. 1936 137- 351-9. ---- influenzae putoriorum. Findeisen, H. Studien zur systematischen Stellung des Bakteriums der spontanen Frettcheninfluenza (Bacterium influenzae putoriorum multiforme Kairies) Zbl. Bakt, 1 Abt 1936, 137: 256-66.—Kairies, A. Die Pasteurellen-Influenza des Frettchens als Modell zur Erklarung der Hemophilus-Influenza des Menschen. Ibid, 9-45, 2 pl. ---- meningitidis. See also Meningitis, Bacteriology. Barwich. M. Ein neues Bakterium als Erreger von akuter Otitis, Meningitis und Pneumonie. Mschr. Ohrenh, 1929, 63: 1025.—Martins, C. Coccobacillus meningitidis. C rend' Soc. biol, 1928, 99: 955-7. ---- parainfluenzae. Klein, J. R. Theoxidationofl(-)-asparticandl(-f-)-glutamic acids by Hemophilus parainfluenzae; note on the preparation of pyridine nucleotides from bakers' yeast by the method of War- burg and Christian. J. Biol. Chem, 1940, 134: 43-57. Also rePr—Lwoff, A., & Lwoff, M. Sur le role physiologique des codehydrogenases pour Hemophilus parainfluenzae. C. rend Acad, sc, 1936, 203: 896-9. parapertussis. Bradford, W. L, & Slavin, B. An organism resembling Hemophilus pertussis, with special reference to color changes produced by its growth upon certain media. Am J Pub Health, 1937, 27: 1277-82.—Eldering, G., & Kendrick, P. A group of cultures resembUng both Bacillus pertussis and Bacillus bronchisepticus but identical with neither. J. Bact, Bait, 1937, 33: 71. ------ Bacillus para-pertussis, a species resembling both BaciUus pertussis and Bacillus bronchisepticus but identical with neither. Ibid, 1938, 35: 561-72 pertussis [Bordet-Gengou] Dohmen, A. *Untersuchungen iiber das Bordet-Gengousche Bakterium [Rostock] 18p. 8? Lippstadt, 1933. Kimball, A. C. *Studies with Hemophilus pertussis [Univ. Pennsylvania] v. p. 23cm. Phila., 1941. Debrfe, R., Marie, J., & Pretet, H. Les races de bacilles de Bordet-Gengou isoiees k Paris. C. rend. Soc. biol, 1928, 98: >t! T VI gi' M- Etudes concernant Hemophilus pertussis (Bordet-Gengou) Holland. Boll. Sez. ital. Soc. internaz. mi- c/ob-. 1936, 8: 71; 95; 97—Gavifio, A., Gayon, J., & Girard, J. Nota sobre el microbio de la tos ferina. Mem. Congr. med. nac. mex, 1910, 4. Congr, 771 —Grooten, O, & Bezssonoff, N. La sensibilite du baciUe de la coqueluche vis-£-vis de la vitamine C et de l'hydroquinol. C. rend. Soc. biol., 1935, 120: 121-3 — Kandyba, L. L., & Davydova, E. V. [Dissociation of the whooping cough baciUus] Ann. Mechnikov. Inst. 1935, 1: 11-28, 2 pl— Kasahara, M., Ogata, S. [et al.] Ueber den Einfluss der ultraakustischen Schallwellen auf die Keuch- hustenbacillen. Mschr. Kinderh, 1938, 72:11-7.—Langer, H, & Wildtgrube, F. Die Identifizierung des Keuchhustenerregers (Bacillus Bordet-Gengou) Zschr. Kinderh., 1931-32, 52: 716- HEMOPHILUS 533 HEMOPHILUS 21 —Lawson, G. M. Modified technique for staining capsules of Hemophilus pertussis. J. Lab. Clin. M, 1939-40, 25: 435- g —Leslie, P. H, & Gardner, A. D. The phases of Haemo- philus pertussis. J. Hyg, Cambr, 1931, 31: 423-34—Mor- ganti, F. Sulla recerca dell'Haemophilus pertussis, Bordet- Gengou, e sul suo valore diagnostico neU'infanzia. Riv. cUn. pediat, 1940, 38: 284-96.—Sauer, L. W., & Hambrecht, L. Bacteriophage of baciUus pertussis. J. Infect. Dis, 1933, 53: 197-200. Also repr.—Shibley, G. S. Differentiation by cataphoretic velocity of fresh and old laboratory strains of H. pertussis. Proc. Soc. Exp. Biol, N. Y, 1932, 30: 31. •------ & Hoelscher, H. Studies on whooping cough; type-specific (S) and dissociation (R) forms of Hemophilus pertussis. J. Exp. M, 1934, 60: 403-18, pl. Also repr.—Shoetensack, M. Additional study on the Bordet-Gengou bacillus with special reference to a new variety of the Bordet-Gengou bacillus. Kitasato Arch, 1935, 12: 174; 285; 1936, 13: 82.—Soare, I, & Tura'i, C. Sur l'isolement du bacille de Bordet-Gengou. C. rend. Soc. biol, 1937, 126: 532.—Toomey, J. A. Recent experi- ments with H. pertussis. J. Pediat, S. Louis, 1934, 5: 258-61. -----Ranta, K. [et al.] The phases or types of H. pertussis. J. Infect. Dis, 1935, 57: 49-56.—Toomey, J. A, & Takfics, W. S. Effect of washing and physical agents on H. pertussis. Ibid, 1938, 62: 313-6.—Watanabe, I. Comparative study of Bacillus pertussis, the animal tvpe bacillus pertussis, and Bacillus bronchisepticus. Jap. J. Exp. M, 1938, 16: 523; 536. ---- pertussis: Culture. Anderson, P. M. A note on the cultivation of Hemophilus pertussis. Med. J. AustraUa, 1941, 2: 224.—Assis, A. de. Nota sobre a conservacao das culturas de Hemophilus pertussis, Bordet-Gengou. Sciencia med, Rio, 1929, 7: 103-5.—Bailey. J. H. A medium for the isolation of Bacillus pertussis. J. Infect. Dis, 1933, 52: 94-6.—Curbelo y Hernandez, A. .El metodo ideal de cultivo del HemophilluS pertussis; detalle de vacuno-terapia. Rev. med. cir. Habana, 1931, 36: 174-85.— Flosdorf, E. W, & Kimball, A. C. Studies with H. pertussis; maintenance of cultures in phase I. J. Bact, Bait, 1940, 39: 255-61.—Hornibrook, J. W. Cultivation of phase I of H. pertussis in a semisynthetic Uquid medium. Pub. Health Rep, Wash, 1939, 54: 1847-51. ------ Nicotinic acid as a growth factor for H. pertussis. Proc Soc. Exp. Biol, N. Y, 1940, 45: 598.—Kuwano, T. Untersuchungen iiber das Wachstum der Bordet-Gengouschen KeuchhustenbaziUen. J. Orient. M, Dairen, 1940, 32: 31.—Sauer, L. Concerning the hemolytic zone of H. pertussis colonies on cough plates. Science, 1937, 86: 427.—Silverthorne, N, & Cameron, C. Whooping cough; beef liver extract blood agar media for growth of H. pertussis. J. Pediat, S. Louis, 1942, 20: 16.—Toomey, J. A, & Takacs, W. S. Changes in morphology of Hemophilus pertussis grown under varying conditions and on different mediums. J. Bact, Bait, 1936, 31:44. Also J. Infect. Dis, 1937, 60:41-6. ------ The effect of various blood mediums on the growth charac- teristics of H. pertussis. Ibid, 1938, 62: 297-9.------■ & Ranta, K. H. pertussis on chocolate brown agar. Ibid, 1936, 59:326-9. ---- pertussis: Pathogenicity. See also Asthma; Bronchitis; Whooping cough. Bradford, W. L. Experimental infection in the mouse pro- duced bv intratracheal inoculation with Haemophilus pertussis. Am. J. Dis. Child, 1938, 56: 467-9. Also Am. J. Path, 1938, 14: 377-83, 2 pl.------& Wold, M. Experimental infection in the mouse produced by intratracheal inoculation with atypical pertussis organism. J. Infect. Dis, 1939, 64: 118-22.— Fonteyne, P. Contribution k l'etude du pouvoir pathog&ie du bacille coquelucheux. C. rend. Soc. biol, 1932, 110: 976.— Rawlings, J. M. Pertussis bacilli in etiology of asthma and bronchitis. Southwest M, 1935, 19: 288-91—Schliiter, W. Der Keuchhustenbacillus Bordet-Gengou und das Keuch- hustenproblem. Erg. Hyg. Bakt, 1936, 18: 1-57.—Sprunt, D. H, Martin, D. S, & McDearman, S. Results of the intra- tracheal injection of the Bordet-Gengou bacillus in the monkey and rabbit. J. Exp. M, 1938, 67: 309-22, 2 pl—Takahashi, S. Ueber einige koUoidchemische Eigenschaften von Kaninchen- blut bei Einfiihrung der Bordetschen KeuchhustenbaziUen. Sei i kwai M. J, 1930, 49: H. 1, 7.—Toomey, J. A. The virulence of H. pertussis. J. Bact, Bait, 1935, 29: 34. ------ Ranta, K, & Takacs, W. S. The virulence of H. pertussis. J. Infect, Dis, 1935, 57: 286-90.—Tuta, J. A. A study of the lymphocytosis foUowing intravenous injections into rabbits of suspension and extracts of Haemophilus pertussis. Fol. haemat, Lpz, 1937, 57: 122-35. ---- pertussis: Toxins, and antibodies. Eldering, G. A study of the antigenic properties of Hemo- philus pertussis and related compounds; an antigenic fraction obtained from Brucella bronchiseptica. Am. J. Hyg, 1941, 34: Sect. B, 1-7. ------ A study of the antigenic properties of Hemophilus pertussis and related organisms; protection and cross-protection tests in mice. J. Bact, Bait, 1942, 43: 78.— Evans, D. G, & Maitland, H. B. The preparation of the toxin of H. pertussis; its properties and relation of immunity. J. Path. Bact, Lond, 1937, 45: 715-31. ------• The toxin of Br. bronchiseptica and the relationship of this organism to H. pertussis. Ibid, 1939, 48: 67-78.—Flosdorf, E. W.. Bondi, A, & Dozois, T. F. Toxins in the several phases of Hemophilus pertussis. J. Bact, Bait, 1942, 43: 265.—Flosdorf, E. W., & Kimball, A. C. Comparison of various physical means of liberation of the agglutinogen from H. pertussis in phase I. J. Immun, Bait, 1940, 39: 287-95. ------ & Dozois, T. F. Studies with H. pertussis; agglutinogenic relationships of the phases. J. Bact, Bait, 1941,41:457-71— Flosdorf, E. W., Kim- ball, A. C, & Chambers, L. A. Studies on H. pertussis; liberation by sonic vibration of a soluble component that absorbs phase I agglutinins. Proc. Soc. Exp. Biol, N. Y, 1939, 41: 122-6.— Kristensen, M. Recherches serologiques sur le bacille de la coqueluohe. C. rend. Soc. biol, 1927, 96: 355-7.—Krueger, A. P , Nicholas, V. C, & Frawley, J. M. Preparation of an active undernatured antigen from Hemophilus pertussis. Proc. Soc Exp. Biol, N. Y, 1933, 30: 1097-9.—Oddy, J. G, & Evan?, D. G. The effects produced by toxic and non-toxic extracts of H. pertussis and Br. bronchiseptica on the blood sugar of rabbits. J. Path. Bact, Lond, 1940, 50: 11-6.— Ohya, K. Zur Ausscheidung des loslichen Toxins von Keuch- hustenbaciUen; Anhang: Einfluss auf die Toxizitat der Keuch- hustenbacillen unter veriinderten Kulturbedingungen. Mitt. Med. Akad. Kioto, 1938, 24: 271.—Powell, H. M, & Jamieson, W. A. The influence of culture media on the antigenic prop- erties of Hemophdus pertussis. J. Indiana M. Ass, 1941, 34: 413.—Soare, J., & Tura'i, C. Contributions k l'etude de quel- ques proprietes serologiques du bacille de Bordet-Gengou. C. rend. Soc. biol, 1937, 126: 533-5.—Takahashi, S. Biologische und serologische Studien iiber Bordetsche KeuchhustenbaziUen. Sei i kwai M. J, 1930, 49: H. 1, 4-6.—Toomey, J. A., McClel- land, J. E, & Lieder, L. E. Further experiments with B. per- tussis filtrate. Proc. Soc. Exp. Biol, N. Y, 1933, 31: 403-6.— Watanabe, I. The toxic substance of BaciUus pertussis. Jap. J. Exp. M, 1938, 16: 529-36.—Wood, M. L. A filtrable toxic substance in broth-cultures of B. pertussis. J. Immun, Bait, 1940, 39: 25-42. HEMOPLEUROPNEUMONIC syndrome. See Lung, Injury; Rib, Fracture. HEMOPNEUMOTHORAX. See under Pneumothorax. HEMOPOIETIC system. See Hematopoietic system. HEMOPOIETIC See under Gastric juice. HEMOPROTOZOA. See Hematozoa. HEMOPTYSIS. See also Respiratory tract, Hemorrhage. Abrahams, A. Haemoptysis and haematemesis. Clin. J, Lond, 1931, 60: 390-4.—Basabe, H. Hemoptisis. In his Grandes sindr. broncopleuropulm, B. Air, 1939, 123-49.— Bortz, W. M. Hemoptysis. In Cyclop. Med. (Piersol-Bortz) Phila, 1939, 7: 215-22.—Burrell, L. S. T. Haemoptysis. Postgrad. M. J, Lond, 1926-27, 2:133-5.—Cabral de Almeida. Da hemoptise. Impr. med, Rio, 1939, 15: 1484-92.—Crofton, G. H. Hemoptysis. U. S. Veterans Bur. M. Bull, 1926, 2: 924-6.—Einiges uber Bluthusten. Mitt. Biochem, 1937, 44: 55.—Emottisi. Progr. ter, Milano, 1910, 65-75.—Fici, V. L'emottisi. In Tisiol. prat. med. (Campani) Milano, 1933, 387-421.—Fonso Gandolfo, C. Hemoptisis. Sem. med, B. Air, 1929, 36: pt 2, 1381-419.—Gee, S. Notes for a lecture on haemoptysis. S. Barth. Hosp. J, Lond, 1932, 40: 19.— Gergely, J. [Pulmonary hemorrhage] Gyogy&szat, 1938, 78: 766.—Good, C. A. Pulmonary hemorrhage. Med. Herald, 1907, n. ser, 26: 446-9.—Hoskin, J. Haemoptysis. In Brit. Encycl. M. Pract. (Rolleston, H.) Lond, 1937, 6: 130-7.— Jacqueiin, A. Les hemoptysies. Medecine, Par, 1931, 12: Suppl, 1-96.—Jones, W. F. Hemoptysis. Univ. Toronto M. J, 1940-41, 18: 36-8.—Larcher. La saignee pulmonaire. Gaz. hop, 1905, 78: 774.—Loeper, M. Les hemoptysies. Progr. med. Par, 1931, 2109-15.—Lubich, V. Le emottisi. BoU. med. trent, 1926, 41: 429; 1927, 42: 1.—Marotta, A. L'emottisi. Morgagni, 1926, 68: 513-23.—Maxwell, J. Hae- moptysis. Postgrad. M. J, Lond, 1936,12:53-8.—Nicholls.J. B. Pulmonary hemorrhage. Virginia M. Month, 1936-37, 63: 230-4.—Oyanguren M., H. Las hemoptisis. Rev. med. Chile, 1941, 69: 195.—Palacios Olmedo, J. de. Hemoptisis. Med ibera, 1931, 15: 265; 305.—Peerwosoebroto. I. [Hae- moptoe] Geneesk. tschr. Ned. Indie, 1935, 75: 1834—Pollak, B. S Pulmonary hemorrhage; its etiology, pathology and therapy. J. M. Soc. N. Jersey, 1928, 25: 239-43. ------& Cohen, S. Hemoptysis; its causes, significance, and treatment. Ibid, 1940 37: 7-14.—Pudymaitis, O. [Pulmonary hemorrhages] Medicina, Kaunas, 1933, 14: 725-34.—Rubinstein, G. R. IHemoptysis] Ter. arkh, 1940, 18: 494-501.— Schaffle, K. Pulmonary hemorrhage. South. M. & S, 1941, 103: 245-9 — Schut, J. [Hemorrhage of the lungs] Geneesk. tschr. Ned. HEMOPTYSIS 534 HEMOPTYSIS Indie, 1931, 71: 1192-7.—Steinberg, I. R. Hemoptisis. Dia m6d, B. Air, 1939, 11: 243-5.—Sterling, S. [Pulmonary hemorrhages] Polska gaz. lek, 1927, 6: 5-11.—Vaccarezza, R. Las hemoptisis. Dia med, B. Air, 1932-33, 5: 477-80. ---- Associated disease. MacDermot, H. E. Sudden death from pulmonary intra- alveolar haemorrhage in a case of asthma associated with pneumonia. Canad. M. Ass. J, 1930, 22: 533.—McLaughlin, A. I. G. Segmental hyperalgesia associated with haemoptysis. Lancet, Lond, 1929, 1:116-9. Also Brit. M. J, 1933, 1:140 — Whitehead, H. G. Hemoptysis associated with epileptiform attacks. Dis. Chest, 1941, 7: 44-7. Also repr. ---- Clinical aspect. Theodoresco, I. Contribution a l'etude des hemoptysies foudroyantes; l'alveolite hemor- ragique. 99p. 25^cm. Par., 1939. Baronci, G. Considerazioni sulle emottisi ncU'infanzia. Policlinico, 1934, 41: sez prat, 2015-22.—Belam, F. A. Fatal haemoptysis in a child of 5. Brit. M. J, 1936, 2: 920.—Cabot, R. C. Hemoptysis; 2 quarts of blood. N. England J. M, 1930, 203: 1087-90. ------ An unusually rapid course in pulmo- nary hemorrhage and pleural effusion. Ibid, 1932, 207: 894.— (soke, L. [Pulmonary hemorrhage in children] Gyogy&szat, I'.i3l, 71: 97-9.—De Michelis, U. Frequenza e significato clinico dell'emoftoe d'allarme. Minerva med. Tor, 1937, 28: 3S7-91.—Ellman, P. Some cUnical problems in relation to haemoptysis. Practitioner, Lond, 1940, 144: 620-7.—Even, R. Les hemoptysies foudroyantes. Bull. Soc. med. hop. Paris, 1936, 3. ser, 52:1487-9.—Goldstein, H. I. Unusual hemoptysis or bronchostaxis. Med. World, 1938, 56: 385.—Hedenius, I. N&gra ovanligare fall af lungblodning. Upsala lak. foren. forh, 1901-2, n. F, 7: 456-75.—Herenstein, G. B. [Case of pro- tracted hemoptysis and fever of functional origin] Sovet. vrach. J, 1936, 1: 1019-22.—Hochrein, M. [Clinical problem of pulmonary hemorrhage] Lije6. vjes, 1940, 62: 471-6.— Jacob, P, & Ja'is. Un nouveau cas d'hemoptysie foudroyante. Rev. tuberc. Par, 1939, 5. ser, 5: 841-3.—Lopez Garcia, P. Estudio de las hemoptisis fulminantes. Med. ibera, Madr, 1032, 26: pt 2, 838-42.—Maestri, O., & Bernabo Silorata, A. Krnoftoc d'allarme; considerazioni clinicherradiologiche su nitre 100 casi. Minerva med. Tor, 1937, 28: pt 2, 163-82.— Morquio, L. La hemoptisis en la pulmonia del nifio. Arch. pediat. I'ruguay, 1933, 4: 466-8.—Omodei Zorini, A, & Milani, A. Appunti e rilievi clinici sopra un certo numero di emottisi non tubercolari. Boll. Soc. med. chir, Pavia, 1928, 6: 757-84, 2 pl.— Raimondi, A. A, Robles, A. A, & Alberta), M. Sobre un caso de hem6ptisis fulminante. Rev. Soc med. int., B. Air, 1!»2S, 4: 587-94, pl.—Recurrent hemoptysis. N. England J. M.. 1935, 212: 1224.—Rinaldi, I. A. L'emottisi cosi detta d'allarme. Gior. tisiol, 1934, 227.—Roberts, J. C. A case of bronchostaxis. Brit. M. J, 1937, 1: 1069.—Sassone, N. Sopra un caso di emottisi. Riv. med, 1927, 35: 97; 118.— Sudden onset of hemoptysis. North Carolina M. J, 1940, 1: 677.—Tucci, F. C, Maderna Agote, A, & Toce, A. Hem6ptisis en la infancia y adolescencia. Prensa med. argent, 1937, 24: 1984-93.- Watkins, A. M. An unusual case of haemoptysis. Med. J. AustraUa, 1938, 1: 493.—Wessler, H. Notes on hemoptysis. J. Mount Sinai Hosp. N. York, 1940-41, 7: 548-53.—Zirakian, S. I. [Cases of pulmonary hemorrhagesl Sovet. vrach. J, 1936, 1: 199.—Zumin, O. L'emoptoe nei lattante. Riv. pat. app. resp, 1934, 3: 155-6. ---- Diagnosis, and prognosis. Baratoux, J. Des fausses hemoptysies. J. med. Paris, 1924, 43: 11.—Becherucci, L. Sulle emorragie di apparente origine bronco-polmonare. Med. prat. Nap, 1926, 11: 241-6.— Borri, C. Emottisi ed ematemesi nei campo deU'otorinolaringo- logia. Valsalva, 1933, 9: 442-9.—Bottoni, E. L'indagine radiologica in casi di emoptoe con particolare riguardo alia diagnosi differenziale fra stenosi mhraUca e tubercolosi pol- monare. Arch, pat, Bologna, 1927, 6: 258-79.—Breton, A. Pronostic eloigne de l'hemoptysie. Prat. med. fr, 1938, 19: 43-61.—Cough and hemoptysis. N. England J. M, 1936, 214: 1153-7.—Feijo, J. Aspetos sintomaticos das hemoptises. Hora med, Rio, 1940, No. 30, 49-52.—Frisch, A. V. Was bedeutet initiate Hamoptoe? Aerztl. Prax, Wien, 1932, 6: 2S4. Also Wien. klin. Wschr, 1932, 45: 307.—Garcia Arra- zuria, J. Falsas hemoptisis desde el punto de vista laringologico. Rev. med. cubana, 1936, 47: 489-92.—Gerlings, P. G. [Bron- choscopy in hemoptysis] Ned. tschr. geneesk, 1935, 79: 4254- 9. Also J. Lar. Otol, Lond, 1936, 51: 508-20, 6 pl.—Goldman, A. Diagnosis and treatment of pulmonary bleeding. Med Clin. N. America, 1936-37, 20: 483-95.—Hiltz, J. E. The significance of haemoptysis. Nova Scotia M. BuU, 1941, 20: 33.5-8.—Hinshaw, H. C. Diagnostic significance of hemoptysis. Minnesota M, 1937, 20: 156-8.—Holmes, G. W. Hemoptysis and the position of the roentgen examination in its diagnosis Radiology, 1938, 31: 131-6.—Janovskaia, L. M. [Hemoptysis as a syndrome simulating pulmonary tuberculosis] KUn. med Moskva, 1933, 11: 465-70.—Karth, B. [Hemorrhage from lungs into both bronchi and pleural cavity; case for diagnosis] Hygiea, Stockh, 1931, 93: 264-6.—Lemon, W. S. The signifi- cance of haemoptysis in the diagnosis of thoracic disease Canad. M. Ass. J, 1930, 22: 639-46.—Lloyd, W. E, The differential diagnosis of hemoptysis. Postgrad. M. J, Lond 1938, 14: 56-9. Also Brompton Hosp. Rep, Lond, 1938, 7: 40-4.—Lopez Trasancos, A. Hemoptisis altas; determination y valoraci6n. Siglo m6d, 1935, 95: 568-71.—Lull, C. He- moptysis; its diagnostic importance. Med. Clin. N. America 1928-29, 12: 1353-6.—McGibbon, J. E. G, & Baker-Bates! E. T. Direct bronchoscopic investigation in haemoptysis without physical or radiological manifestations. Brit. M. J, 1937, 1: 109-13.—Manseau, O. The diagnosis of hemoptysis' Bull, san, Montreal, 1941, 41: 7-11.—Marcy, C. H. The significance of pulmonary hemorrhage. Dis. (Ihest, 1939, 5: No. 7, 16-20.—Moisescu, T. [Differential dingim-is in hemo- ptysis] RomAnia med, 1928, 6: 214-6.- Mwrson, M. 0. Bronchoscopic aspects of hemoptysis. Tr. Am. Bionchosc. Soc 1936, 19: 85-92. Also Ann. Otol. Rhinol, 1936. 45: 1101-8.— Pritchard, S, & Gordon, J. K. M. The significance of hemo- ptysis. Bull. Battle Creek. Sanit, 1931, 26: 114-20. Also Southwest. M, 1930, 11: 468-72.—Remy-Roux. De la valeur du symptome hemoptysie devant la radiologic Bull. Soc. eiectroradiol. med. France, 1939, 27: 103-5.—Rodriguez Sayago, M. J. Interpretation clinica y patogenica de la hemo- ptisis. Arch, med, Madr, 1932, 35: 144-6.—Scheel, H. Simulation jahrelanger Hiimoptysen (Beitrag zur Kasuistik) Munch, med. Wschr, 1930, 77: 980.—Schmidt, W., & Unholtz, K. Die Hamoptoe im Rontgenbild. Zschr. Tuberk, 1937, 78: 1-24.—-Shtefko, V. G. [Roentgen and pathologo-anatomical aspect of hemorrhagic symptoms in the lungs.] Probl. tuberk, Moskva, 1941, No. 7, 47-50, pl.—Thomson, St C. Hemorrhage from the throat (hemoptvsis not of pulmonary origin) Ann. Otol. Rhinol, 1928, 37: 209-12.—Tremble, G. E. Haemoptysis from the viewpoint of the Iaryngologist. Canad. M. Ass. J, 1931, 25: 700.—Vinson, P. P. The significance of hemoptysis. J. S. Carolina M. Ass, 1934, 30: 72-4.------The diagnostic significance and clinical management of pulmonary hemorrhage. Virginia M. Month, 1937-38, 64: 492-4.—Wood, F. G. The value of radiology in the elucidation of haemoptysis. Brit. M. J, 1938, 2: 211-3 [Discussion] 243. ------ Lloyd, W. E. [et al.] X-rays and haemoptysis. Ibid, 243.—Wiirtzen, C. H. [Differential diagnoses of hemoptysis] Ugeskr. laeger, Pi.'ifi, 98:320-4. ---- Etiology. See also names of primary diseases and causes as Bronchiectasis; Heart disease; Lung, Injury; Paragonimus; Trachea, Varix; Tuberculosis, pulmonary, &c. Balke, B. *Ueber Lungenblutungen kar- dialen Ursprungs, besonders bei der Mitral- stenose. 36p. 23cm. Berl., 1937. Cygler, B. Contribution k l'etude des hemoptysies chez les cardiaques. 74p. 8? Par., 1933. Delpech, C. Contribution a l'etude dea hemoptysies bronchectasiques. 75p. 8? Par., 1928. Almansa, S, & Rapado, A. Sobre las hemoptisis en las infiltraciones secundarias. Med. ibera, 1933, 27: pt 2, 713.— Ameuille, P. H6moptysies en dehors de la tuberculose evolu- tive. Bull, med. Par, 1938, 52: 465-7. ------ Delhomme [et al.] Syndrome h6moptoiique malin par anevrysme inter- stitiel du poumon. Bull. Soc. med. hop. Paris, 1936, 3. ser, 52: 208-12.—Ameuille, P., Gautier, J, & Iglesias-Bettancourt. Hemoptysie foudroyante par communication directe d'un vaisseau et d'une bronche lobaire. Ibid, 204-8.—Bezancon, F., & Jacquelin, A. Hemoptysies et troubles vaso-moteurs, Presse med, 1929, 37: 733-7.—Bondolfi, G. Sulla presunta influenza di particolari treponemi nelle determinazioni delle emottisi. Riforma med, 1927, 43: 321-3.—Calabrese. S. A proposito dell'emottisi cardiaca male interpretata. Policlinico, 1932, 39: sez. prat, 1037-42.—Chukanov, V. A. [Nontuber- culous hemoptysis.] Klin, med, Moskva, 1930, 8: 167-73.— Cole, E. C. Hemorrhage in pulmonary disease. Virginia M. Month, 1936-37,63:329-32.—D'Anna, A. Les hemoptysies non tuberculeuses. Union med. Canada, 1932, 62: 784-9.—David- son, M. Haemoptysis of obscure origin; a critical account of 2 unusual cases. Lancet, Lond, 1927, 1: 122-5, 2 pl.—Douady, D, & Cohen, R. Syndrome de Loeffler avec hemoptysies et accidents renaux fugaces. Rev. tuberc. Par, 1938, 5. ser, 4: 88-92.—Farberman, V. I. [On hemoptysis following extra- abdominal operations] Vest, khir, 1939, 57: 300-3.—Francfis, A. Un caso de pseudohemoptisis producida por sanguijuela ignorada. An. Hosp. S. Jos6, Madr, 1933-34, 5: 113-5.— Garcia Trivino. Un caso de hemorragia pulmonar en un ayiador. Arch, med, Madr, 1934, 37: 185.—Gasparini, A. L'emottisi omolaterale in corso di pneumotorace terapeutico. Gior. tisiol, 1929, 7: 13-8.—Gomez, F. D, & Gaggero, A. A proposito de una hemoptLsis recidivante cr6nica de causa desconocida. Rev. m6d. lat. amer, B. Air, 1928-29, 14: 179-90.—Guizetti, H. U, & Dinkier, G. Zur Klinik und Pathologie der kardialen, nicht infarktbedingten Hamoptyse. Munch, med. Wschr, 1938, 85: 295-300.—Hagiescu, D, & Almasanu, S. [Azotemic hemoptysis] Spitalul, 1935, 55: 101.—Harris, K, &; Kerley, P. Vena azygos lobe with haemop- HEMOPTYSIS 535 HEMOPTYSIS tvsis Proc R. Soc. M, Lond, 1934, 27: 1231.—Hernandez niaz A Ueber die neurovegetativen Haemoptysen. Schweiz. med ' Wschr, 1940, 70:163-6.—Hertzberg, G. [Case of current haemoptysis with combined etiology] Med. rev, Bergen, 1933, nn■ 251-5 —Hoffmann, A. NichttuberkuloseLungenblutungen. Deut med. Wschr, 1926, 52: 1581-3.—Homan, R. B. The cause and control of pulmonary hemorrhage. Southwest. M, 1926 10: 175-7.—Janovskaia, L. M. [Hemoptysis of non- tuberculous etiology and its differential diagnosis] Borba s tuberk 1933,11:143-9.—Kozakovsky, L. P. [Hemoptysis and hemorrhage of tuberculous and non-tuberculous origin] Klin. med Moskva, 1938, 16: 1237-41.—Laband, A. Hamoptoe bei nicht tuberkuloser Erkrankung. Jahrb. Kinderh, 1928-29, 3 F 72:111.—Levin, N. M. Hemoptysis of obscure etiology Tr Am Ther Soc, 1937, 37: 92.—Llerena, A. Hemoptisis no tuberculosas. Med. ibera, 1927, 21: 180-2.—Milani, G. Le emottisi non tubercolari. Tubercolosi, 1926, 18: 253-62.— Morelli, E. Rapporto fra emottisi e condizioni pleuriche. Boll. Soc. med. chir, Pavia, 1921, 34: 263-6.—Moreno Ceniceros, J. Hemoptisis neurovasculares. Arch, med, Madr, 1935, 38: 196-200.—Mosco, M. Emottisi provocate dalle iniezioni endovenose di calcio. Gazz. internaz. med. chir, 1929, 37: 728__Oppenheimer, B. S, & Schwartz, S. P. Paroxysmal nulmonary hemorrhages; the syndrome in young adults with mitral stenosis. Am. Heart J, 1933, 9:14-25.—Ovidio, F. R.D\ Hemoptisis no tuberculosas. Rev. As. med. argent, 1936, 50: 1223-32 —Paita, L. Emottisi non tubercolari e false emottisi. Med prat. Nap, 1927, 12: 217-22.—Petrov, A. I. [Three cases of grave hemoptysis of obscure origin] Vest, khir, 1931, 24: 251.__Portmann, G, & Retrouvey, H. Les hemoptysies non tuberculeuses. Fol. otolar. orient, 1935, 2: 201-11.—Proft, E. Ueber die Quellen starker Lungenblutungen bei Stauungs- lungen. Zschr. khn. Med, 1931-32, 119: 218-35—Pund, E. R 'Greenblatt, R. B, & Thompson, C. Hemoptysis in malig- nant hydatid mole. J. Am. M. Ass, 1938, 110: 1999-2001 — Rabino, A. Le emottisi non tubercolari. Minerva med. Tor, 1932, 23: 845-52.—Rodriguez Pastor, J. Estudio de las hemoptisis que ocurren en Puerto Rico desde el punto de vista etiologico. Bol. As. med. Puerto Rico, 1927, 21: 55-62.— Saliba, J. The cause of blood spitting. South. M. & S, 1931, 93- 9-11.—ScheidemandeL E. Nichttuberkuldse Lungen- blutungen. Klin. Wschr, 1927, 6: 554-7.—Scheurer, O. Hiimoptysis bei Mitralstenose unter besonderer Beriicksichti- gung der iibrigen Lungenblutungen. Miinch. med. Wschr, 1938, 85: 1514-9.—Scripci-Giurgiu, G. [Hemoptysis after injection of neoarsphenamine] Rom&nia med, 1931, 9: 132.— Smith, H. L. Pulmonary hemorrhage accompanying acute cardiac infarction. Med. Clin. N. America, 1932, 15: 1581- 4,—Stephens, H. B. Pulmonary hemorrhage associated with endothelioma of the lung and pleura; a report of 2 cases. In Med. Surg. Tributes to H. Brunn, Berkeley, 1942, 525-36.— Stoichita, H. [Hemoptysis in artificial pneumothorax] Ro- mania med, 1932, 10: 57.—Tecon, H. Hemoptysies non tuberculeuses. Praxis, Bern, 1929, 18: H. 31, 1; 3; H. 32, 1. Also Rev. med. Suisse rom, 1929, 49: 589-606.—Teodorescu, V. T. [Pure vasomotor hemoptysis due to surgical interven- tion] Spitalul, 1936, 56: 492-6.—Tronchetti, F. Le emottisi non tubercolari. Gior. tisiol, 1936, 49-57.—Vieten. Ueber 3 Falle von Hamoptoe in Mitralfehlern. Med. KUn, Berl, 1930 26: 1857.—Vignes, H. Les hemoptysies gravido-cardia- ques. Progr. med. Par, 1938, 1349-53.—Vinson, P. P. Pulmonary hemorrhage in cases of pulmonary tuberculosis, chronic bronchiectasis and mitral stenosis. Proc. Mayo Clin, 1927, 2: 41.—Walter, E. Zur Frage der Entstehungsursache von Lungenblutungen. Munch, med. Wschr, 1938, 85: 1259.— Weil, P. E, & Gregoire, R. Un cas de grandes hemoptysies non tuberculeuses d'origine hemogenique; spienectomie; guerison. BuU. Soc. med. hop. Paris, 1928, 3. ser, 52: 340-4. --- Pathogenesis. Effertz, M. *Ueber Blutungen bei Haemo- ptoe aus Lungencavernen. 26p. 21cm. Bonn, 1936. Akkerman, V. V., & Fainstein, N. G. [Pathogenesis of pulmonary hemorrhages] Klin, med, Moskva, 1937, 15: 295- 300.—Ameuille, P., & Fauvet, J. Origine anatomique des hemoptysies. Bull. Soc. m6d. hop. Paris, 1941, 57: 290-3.— Baillet. L'h6moptysie et le vent. Arch. Soc. sc. mid. biol. Montpellier, 1929, 10: 101-7.—Brandt, M. Beitrag zur Kenntnis angioneurotischer Lungenblutungen. Krankheits- forschung, 1928, 6: 239-51.—Chaize, J. H6moptysies et conditions meteorologiques. Arch. med. chir. app. resp. Par, 1930, 5: 155-78.—Chukanov, V. A. [Pathogenesis and treat- ment of hemoptysis] Klin, med, Moskva, 1940, 18: No. 10, 15-25.—Cybulski, H. Einige Bemerkungen uber Lungenblu- tungen. Zschr. Tuberk, 1903, 4: 299-302.—Foss. Entgeg- nung auf Dr Gebsers Arbeit: iiber Luftdruckvenindetungen und Lungenblutungen. Ibid, 1905, 7: 352-4.—Giovanni, A. A proposito deU'insorgere di emottisi ex clima. Minerva med. Tor, 1930, 21: 263.—Jacob, P, & Brocard, H. Les hemo- ptysies foudroyants avec rejet minime de sang dans la tuber- culose pulmonaire; le role de la transsudation sanguine dans la pathogenie des hemoptysies. Rev. tuberc. Par, 1939, 5. ser, 5: [Discussion] 213.—Longo, A. Emottisi, crasi sanguigna e fenomeno del laccio. Riformalmed, 1929, 45: 767-9.— Mercader, N. Estudio sobre hemoptisis. Rey. As. m6d. argent, 1934, 48: 1046-52.—Rimbaud, L, Anselme-Martin, ^•', •., s> P- Hemoptysies par choc. Arch. Soc. sc. med. biol. Montpellier, 1935-36, 17: 430-4.—Sheely, R. F. Pro- thrombin deficiency in pulmonary tuberculosis; clinical relation and significance in hemoptysis. J. Am. M. Ass, 1941, 117: 1603-6.—Simoes Ferreira, L. As chamadas hemoptises suplementares. Med. contemp, Lisb, 1939, 57: 1-3.— Szarvas, A. [Climatic conditions causing hemorrhage of the lungs] Orv. hetil, 1927, 71: 9. ---- Pathology. Clarisse, H. L. J. *L'image granitSe post- hemopto'ique des poumons [Nancy] 51 p. 24cm. Lille, 1934. Le S^ac'h, C. M. *L'image granitee post- hemoptoique. 141p. 8? Par., 1936. Ppltjgradt, W. *Ueber todliche Blutungen aus nicht tuberkulosen bronchiektatischen Ka- vernen in den Lungen. 23p. 8? Greifsw., 1928. Beitzke, H. Quelle einer Lungenblutung, nach 49 Jahren autoptisch geklart. Beitr. Klin. Tuberk, 1938-39, 92:483-6 — Capelli, F. Variazioni del potere complementare del sangue in corso di emottisi. Riv. pat. cUn. tuberc, 1937, 11: 494-8.— Carnot. Collapsus ateiectasique, suraigu et passager par hemoptysie. Rev. gin. clin. ther, 1936, 50: 33-6.—Debski, J. [Fatal pulmonary hemorrhages] Nowiny lek, 1938, 50: 373-7.—D'Hour, H, & Bera, J. Documents cUniques et recherches experimentales concernant l'image granitee post- hemopto'ique. Rev. tuberc. Par, 1934, 4. ser, 2: 197-207.— Giraud, G, Mas, P, & Boisbeunet. Un cas d'ateiectasie pulmonaire massive post-hemoptolque. Arch. Soc. sc. med. biol. Montpellier, 1938, 19: 242-52.—Gonzalez Battle, P. Las im&genes granitees post-hemopt6icas. Rev. med. cubana, 1937, 48: 61-6.—Meersseman, F, & Cameljn, A. Un nouveau cas d'hemoptysie foudroyante avec rejet minime de sang; etude histo-pathologique. Rev. tuberc. Par, 1939, 5. ser, 5: 978-82.—Morlock, H. V, & Pinchin, A. J. S. Haemoptysis: a note on pathology and treatment. Brit. M. J, 1934, 2: 762-4.—Orszagh, O. The condition of the lung after haemop- tysis. Tubercle, Lond, 1935-36, 17: 1-5.—Silvani, A. G. Emottisi ed emostasi; il tempo di coagulazione. Arch. farm. sper, 1937, 64: 171-80.—Trepiccioni, E. Emottisi e riflessi sino-carotidei. Riv. pat. clin. tuberc, 1932, 6: 509.—Wolaj, I. Colapso masivo atelect^sico del pulm6n por hemoptisis. Sem. m6d, B. Air, 1933, 40: 000-70. ---- Surgical aspect. Arendar, L, & RosenfeVd, A. Frenicoex6resis hemostdtica. Dfa med, B. Air, 1937, 9: 407.—Armand-Delille, P., Paillas. J. P, & Hacker, B. Pneumothorax extra-pleural medical pratique d'urgence pour hemoptysie grave. Bull. Soc med. hop. Paris, 1938, 3. ser, 54: 608.—Bertotto, F, & Dal Lago, R. Sobre dos casos de hemoptisis tratados con exito por la freni- cectomia. Sem. med, B. Air, 1929, 26: pt 2, 1579-81.— Beye, H. L. Recurring hemorrhage in chronic suppurative conditions of the lung; treatment by ligation of the pulmonary artery; report of 2 cases. Arch. Surg, 1929, 18: 520-5.— Blades, B, & Graham, E. A. The surgical treatment of intrac- table pulmonary hemorrhage. Internat. Clin, 1939, n. ser, 2:-4: 77-83, 7 pl.—Capdehourat, E. L, & Mazzei, E. S. Neu- motorax artificial controlateral de efecto hemostfitico en una hemoptisis grave; perforation pulmonar benigna. Dia med, B. Air, 1937, 9: 89.—Colbert, C, & Chatard, J. La thora- coplastie hemostatique. Paris med, 1927, 63: 113-5.— Eloesser, L. Observations on sources of pulmonary hemorrhage and attempts at its control. J. Thorac. Surg, 1937-38, 7: 671-9.—Etcheverry Boneo, F., & Egiies, J. Toracoplastia hemosUtica. Sem. med, B. Air, 1937, 44: pt 2, 1361-4 — Ferrari, G. II pneumoperitoneo nella terapia deU'emottisi. Minerva med. Tor, 1936, 27: 445-9. —---— & Balestrieri, F. II pneumoperitoneo nella terapia deU'emottisi. Boll. Soc. med. chir, Pavia, 1936, 50: 407-9.—Kiselev, A. G, & Kapush- chevsky, A. S. [Case of thoracoplasty applied in a case of profuse pulmonary hemorrhage] Probl. tuberk, Moskva, 1939 No. 9-10, 97.—McIver, M. A. A case of hemoptysis treated by operation. Boston M. & S. J, 1927, 197: 315-8 — Mestci, Z. Die Unterbindung des Pulmonalishauptastes zur Therapie schwerer Hiimoptysen. Zbl. Chir, 1938, 65: 1294.— Minet, J., & Dupire, J. Sur le traitement des hemoptysies rebelles par la phrenicectomie. Progr. med. Par, 1935, 97- 105 ------ Sur le traitement des hemoptysies rebelles par la thoracoplastie. Ibid, 689.—Moty. Procede rapide d'ouver- ture du thorax en cas d'hemorragie pulmonaire grave. Bull. Soc. chir. Paris, 1907, n. ser, 33: 909.—Petrin. 1. La freni- coexeresi nelle emottisi. Riv. med. social, tuberc, 1933, 10: 264-70. ------■ II pneumotorace emostatico. Lotta tuberc, 1934, 5: 167-81.—Pitkin, C. E. Repeated severe hemoptysis necessitating pneumonectomy. Ann. Otol. Rhinol, 1941, 50: 914-6.—Rabboni, F. Tecnica e risultati clinici della alcoohzza- zione dei nervi intercostali secondo Leotta nella emottisi. Riv. med. social, tuberc, 1936, 13: 121-38.—Sauerbruch, F. Blutende Lungen. Arch. klin. Chir, 1937, 189: 533-7.— Zarate, F. J. Pneumothorax in hemoptysis. Month. Bull. Bur. Health, Manila, 1939, 19: 161. HEMOPTYSIS 536 HEMOPTYSIS ---- Treatment. See also Hemostasis. Alexander, H. La hemorragia pulmonar y su tratamiento. Rev. med. germ. iber. amer, 1938, 11: 11-7.—Al\ira Lasierra, M. El sindrome hemopt6ico en la clinica. Clin, lab, Zara- goza, 1933, 22: 123-32.—Arbuckle, M. F. Pulmonary hemor- rhacc studied and treated bv the bronchoscopist. Tr. Am. Bronchosc. Soc, 1936. 19: 77-84. Also Ann. Otol. Rhinol, 1936, 45: 1114-21.- Ascoli, M. Treatment of haemoptysis. Brit. M. J, 1929, 1: 549.—Balbi Robecco, J. M, & Doyle, .1. Tratamiento de las hemoptisis por el bloqueo novocainico del simp&tico cervical; probable acci6n patogenica de la hista- mina. Dfa in.'d, B. Air, 1941, 13: 267-73.—Belteceanu. [Treatment of hemoptysis] Romania med, 1930, 8: 78.— Itanyai, A. L. The treatment of pulmonary hemorrhage. Wisconsin M. J, 1932, 31: 88-91. Also repr.—Bard, L. Du role du decubitus dans revolution et le traitement des hemoptysies congestives. Presse m6d, 1927, 35: 1009. Also Med. Press & Circ, Lond, 1929, n. ser, 127: 131.—Beaumont, G. E. Treatment of hemoptysis. In Treat. Gen. Pract, 2. ed, Lond, 1938, 1: 27-31. Also Brit. M. J, 1935, 1: 25. Also Brompton Hosp. Rep, Lond, 1935, 4: 97-100.—Brin- court, J. Deux traitements recents des hemoptysies. Hopital, 1934, 22: jS.L-91.—Bufalini, B. Delle malattie curate in Cortona; emottisi ed emormesi polmonare. Gior. progr. pat, Venez, 1843, ser. 2, 4: 634-43.—Capaldo, L. Sui moderni mezzi di terapia deU'emottisi. Policlinico, 1935, 42: sez. prat, 1683-90.-—Capelli, F. L'azione della vitamina C nelle emottisi. Riv. pat. clin. tuberc, 1937, 11: 317-21.—Carleton, H. H. Problems in the treatment of haemoptysis. Bristol Med. Chir. J, 1928, 45: 39-50, pl.—Chandler, F. G. The treatment of haemoptysis. Lancet, Lond, 1930, 1: 588.—Chernobulsky, Z. N. [Xcw treatment in hemoptysis and pulmonary hemor- rhage] Probl. tuberk, Moskva, 1937, No. 6, 77-80.—Cioffi. E. Le recentissime cure deU'emottisi. Gazz. osp, 1937, 58: 49-51.—Ciorapciu, S, & Popescu, R. [Treatment of hemop- i ysis by sub-cutaneous injections of oxygen] Romania med, 1936, 14: 193.—Cobet, R. Lungenblutungen und ihre Be- k.mrpfung. Ther. Gegenwart, 1939. 80: 1-7.—Cordier, V, ( roizat, P, & Plauchu, M. A propos de la transfusion sanguine dans les hemoptysies. Lyon med, 1933, 152: 149-53.— Dickey, W. A. The treatment of pulmonarv hemorrhage. Med. Stand, 1905, 28: 239.—Diez, C, & Gormalez-Rubio, L. Tratamiento de las hemoptisis por las inyeceiones subcutaneas de aire. Arch, med, Madr, 1934, 37: 1035. Di Gcronimo, G. II pneuma precostale neUa cura delle emottisi. (lior. tisiol, 1936, 15.—Filinski, W. [Treatment of hemorrhages of the lung] Polska gaz. lek.. 1926, 5: 081.—Fourestier, M, Racine, M, & Paillas, J. Hemoptysies. dvscrasies sanguines et trans- fusion. Rev. tuberc. Par, 1937, 5. ser, 3: 754-73.—Fraser, N. D. Auto-haemotherapv in haemoptysis. Brit. M. J, 1935, 1: 389.—G6mez, F. D, -8.—Norman, V. P. Haemoptysis and its treat- ment. Chn. J, Lond, 1933, 62: 423-7.-Peschky, L. IRoenE ?^otr, 43; 125-7.—Robinson, W.J. The rational treatment of pulmonarv hemorrhage. Ther. Med, N. Y, 1907, 1: 217-26—Schedtlcr, O. Was soil der praktische Arzt bei Lungenblutungen vor- nehmen? Med. Klin, Berl, 1938, 34: 733-5.------& Starlinger, W. [et al.] Was soil der praktische Arzt bei Lungon- blutungen vornehmen? Ibid. [Discussion] 733: 768.— Schlapper, K. Ueber Lungenbluten. Aerztl. Rdscn, 1928, 38: 117.—Schlayer, C. R. Wie verhiilt sich der praktische Arzt bei Lungen- und Magenhlutungen? Zschr. iirztl. Fort- bild, 1929, 26: 577-9.—Schroder, G. Ueber die Behandlung der Lungenblutung. Deut. med. Wschr, 1934, 60: 1792-4.— Senater, H. Zur Pflege bei Lungenblutungen. Kranken- pflege, 1901-2, 1: 97-9.—Sheckles, I,. W, jr. The manage- ment of hemoptysis. Bull. John Sealv Hosp, Galvest, 1939 ■ 40, 1: 129-32.—Silberbauer, S. F. The treatment of haemo- ptysis. Med. J. S. Africa, 1920-27, 22: 35-8.—Spangenberg, J. J, Munist, L, & Ardaiz, A. La oxigenoterapia en las hemo- ptisis. Rev. As. med. argent, 1935, 49: 248-55.—Steinberg, I. R. Tratamiento de las hemopiisis. Dia med, B. Air, 1939, 11: 259-01.—Theodoreanu, T. I. [Treatment of hemoptysis by human heterohemotherapy] Spitalul, 1940, 60: 310-3.— Tice, F. Therapy of hemoptysis. .1. Am. M. Ass, 1938, U0: 579.—Vaccarezza, R. Tratamiento de las hemoptisis. Dfa med, B. Air, 1932-33, 5: 555.—Vinson, P. P. The etiology and treatment of pulmonary hemorrhage, with espceial refer- ence to bleeding in cases of so-called drv bronchiectasis South. M. J, 1941, 34: 203-7.—Wolf, J. E, & Ducliaine, J. Le traitement d'urgence des hemoptysies. Bruxelles mid 1933-04, 14: 807-9. " ---- Treatment: Drugs. Ascoli, M. Sulla cura deU'emottisi con le iniezioni tracheali di adrenahna (metodo Giuffrida) Riforma med, 1931, 47: 1143.—Bedo, E. Ueber die Wirkung des Coagulen bei Lungen- blutungen. Med. Klin, Berl, 1928, 24: 784.—Bcnincori, A. Emostasi con la calcioterapia nella emottisi. Rass. clin. ter, 1931, 30: 336-8.—Bertucci, E. A. Some observations with dichlorobenzine terpenolic compound vapor in hemoptysis N. Orleans M. & S. J, 1932, 84: 620-4.—Bonarrico, N. II rosso Congo nella cura delle emottisi tubercolari. Riv. med. social, tuberc, 1938, 15: 341.—Bruno, F. Ueber die Behand- lung von Lungenblutungen mit endotrachealen Adrenalin- injektionen nach Giuffrida. Tuberkulose, Munch, 1933, 13: 61-3.—Cahis, M. Tratamiento de la hemorragia pulmonar. Rev. homeop, Barcel, 1893, 4: 147-53.—Campanacci, D. Lo sputo sanguigno di un pneumotoracizzato affetto di epato- nefrite e la sua cura: elogio della salsapariglia. Minerva med. Tor, 1939, 30: 25-8.—Caputo, B. L'emetina, suo valore emostatico e meccanismo d'azione nell'emottisi. Cult. med. mod. Pal, 1935, 14: 12-22.—Cayrel, M. El nitrito di amile nella terapia della emottisi. Tubercolosi, 1926, 18: 34-7.— Cetrangolo, A. Utilidad de las inyeceiones de extracto de cuerpo amarillo en las hemoptisis y en las reacciones mens- truates de las tuberculosas. Sem. med, B. Air, 1926, 33: 1205-7.—Courcoux, A. Traitement des hemoptysies par lea injections sous-cutanees d'oxygene. Rev. tuberc. Par, 1934, 4. ser, 2: 159-61.—Curti, O. P. Tratamiento de las hemo- ptisis por el tartrato doble de antimonio y potasio. Sem. med, B. Air, 1926, 33: 38.—D'Agostino, F. Accidenti emottoici da calcioterapia endovenosa. Gior. tisiol, 1935, 74.—D'Angelo, F. Intorno alia cura delle emottisi col metodo Giuffrida. Policlinico, 1934, 41: sez. prat, 566-9. Also Prensa med. argent, 1934-35, 21: pt 2, 1333-5.—Fantonetti, G. B. Due casi di pneumonorragia intermittente prontamente risanata col solfato di chinina. Gior. progr. pat, Venez, 1841, 15: 650-7.—Ferrer y Rovira, J. F. El rojo Congo en las hemo- ptisis. Tuberculosis, Habana, 1933-34, 5: 64.—Galli, F. Una nuova terapia deU'emottisi; iniezioni endotrachoali di adrenalma e coaguleno. Riv. pat. clin. tuberc, 1932, 6: 128-30.—-Giuffrida, F. L'adrenalina per via endo-tracheale nella cura deU'emottisi. Boll. Soc. biol. sper, 1926, 1: 212. Also Munch, med. Wschr, 1928, 75: 302.—Gui (Le) dans les hemoptysies et les hemorragies. Lyon med, 1936, 157: 22a — King, D. B. Some observations on the treatment of pulmonary hemorrhage by adrenalin chlorid. Internat. Clin, 1905, 15. ser, 2: 26-32.—King, W.E. The use of pituitrininhaemop- \y.ala- £im- ReP- Melbourne Hosp, 1938, 9: 102.—Lucacer, 1 ,*i, Sulluso dell'adrenaUna per via endotracheale nella cura dell emottisi. Policlinico, 1930, 37: sez. prat, 1513—Mac- A?narld' D* SuprarenaUn in pulmonary haemorrhage. Brit. M. J, 1904, 1: 1246.—Monaco, M. Emottisi guarita colla segala cornuta. Filiatre sebezio, Nap, 1836, 12: 138.—Ortega Morejon, D. L. de. Tratamiento de las hemoptisis por loa yasodilatadores. Congr. espan. internac. tuberc. (1910) ».' \ 9j°ngr'' 677-85.—Pangrazzi, M. L'iniezione endo- tracheale di coagulenoadrenalina nella cura delle emottisi. Minerva med. Tor, 1903, 24: pt 2, 63-5.- -Pennetti, G. Le iniezioni endotracheal! di HjO nella cura dell.- emottisi. Riforrna med, 1936, 52: 114-7.—Pierini, E. A. Tratamiento de las hemoptisis por el metodo de Giuffrida-Galli. Sem. med, a ' ui"' 1935, 42: 55-8.—Ponnavoy-Basilaire. Le traitement des1 hemoptysies par le rouge Congo en injection intraveineuse. Echo med. nord, 1940, 3. ser, 11: 27-30.—Poras, J. Zur Therapie der Haemoptoe (unter Berucksichtigung des Sistonal) HEMOPTYSIS 537 HEMORRHAGE Fortsch. Ther, 1929, 5: 223.—Puliga, G. Su di un nnove metodo di terapia nelle emottisi; l'uso endovenoso di soluzioni di rosso Congo. Gazz. med. ital, 1936, 45: 141-5.—Raimondi, A. A., & Sangiovanni, A. Tratamiento de las hemoptisis por el" veneno de la Vipera rusellii. Prensa med. argent, 1937, 24: 42-6.—Restivo, A. Comportamento della pressione sanguigna ed azione della canfora negli emoftoici. Gior. tisiol, 1934, 7-13.—Soto Pradera, E. El sulfato de magnesia en la tosferina. Bol. Soc. cubana pediat, 1938, 10: 173-82.— Stepanova, M. P. [Atropine as blood restorer in pulmonary hemorrhages] Klin, med, Moskva, 1931, 9: 209-12.—Taglia- ferro, E. Alcune considerazioni sull'iniezione intratracheale di adrenalina e coaguleno nella cura deU'emottisi. Rass. internaz. clin. ter, 1932, 13: 1055-60.—Teohari, A, & Parissidi, C, & Ba'iso'iu, D. Note sur un cas d'hemoptysie coincident avec la presence d'un foyer pulmonaire fuso-spirillaire; guerison parl'emetine. C. rend. Soc. biol, 1900, 104: 1364.—Thieme, L. Zur Behandlung der Lungenblutungen mit subkutanen Gela- tineinjektionen. Miinch. med. Wschr, 1902, 49: 184.— Trepiccioni, E. II trattamento delle emottisi con iniezioni endo-tracheali di farmaci coagulanti. Policlinico, 1932, 39: sez. prat, 837-43.—Troflmov, K. A. [Atropin in treatment of pulmonary hemorrhages and hemoptysis] Sovet. vrach. gaz, 1932, 36: 411.—Tyszka, K. [Hemostatic action of stryphnon in lung hemorrhages] Polska gaz. lek, 1928, 7: 116-8.— Vaccarezza, R. F. Tratamiento de las hem6ptisis por inyec- ci6n intratraqueal de medicamentos hemostdticos. Prensa med. argent, 1934-35, 21: 779-83.—Weidinger, E. Ein neues Mittel zur Bekampfung schwerer Lungenblutungen. Wien. klin. Wschr, 1926, 39: 1193. HEMORRHAGE. See also Hemorrhagic diathesis; also under tissues and organs affected as Brain, Hemorrhage; Blood vessels, Injuries; also Epistaxis; Hema- temesis; Hematuria; Hemoptysis; Melena; Wounds, &c. Lorca Barcel6, C. *La sangre; contribu- ci6n al estudio de algunas hemorragias [Univ. Chile] 63p. 8? Valparaiso, 1925. Bezy, E. [Course of spontaneous hemorrhage] Budapest orv. ujs, 1926, 24: 457-60.—Bohl, C. Die Blutungen; ihre Entstehung und Klassifizierung. Deut. tierarztl. Wsehr, 1927, 35: 661-3.—Delaunay, H. Hemorragies. In Traite physiol. norm. path. (Roger & Binet) 2. ed. Par, 1904,7: 291-328.— Gordon, A. K. Haemorrhage. Med. Press & Circ, Lond, 1929, n. ser, 127: 213.—MacPhail, J. M. Erratic haemorrhages and cedemas. Ibid, 1930, 130: 317.—Shuman, J. W. Hemor- rhage. Med. J. & Rec, 1929, 129: 8.—Tonkes, E. [Acute haemorrhage] Ned. tschr. geneesk, 1932, 76: 644-69.— Vaux, N. W, & Payne, F. L. Hemorrhage. In Cyclop. Med. (Piersol-Bortz) Phila, 1940, 12: 387-415, pl. --- accidental. See Placenta, Detachment. --- allergic. See Allergy, hemorrhagic. --- Bleeding time. See also Blood coagulation. Schreber, I. *Experimentelle Untersuchun- gen uber die Blutungszeit [Berlin] 32p. 8? Charlottenb., 1928. Arutiunian, M. S, & Pokrovsky, P. I. [Investigation of the rate of natural cessation of hemorrhages in various degrees of low atmospheric pressure] Khirurgia, Moskva, 1938, No. 3, 46-51.—Copley, A. F, & Lalich, J. J. Bleeding time in men. Am. J. Physiol, 1941, 133: 246. ------ Bleeding time in normal and heparinized mice. Ibid, 247. ------ Method of and apparatus for determining bleeding time. U. S. Patent Off, 1942, No. 2,276,021.—Derouaux, G. Amines sympathico- mimetiques et temps de saignement moyen. C. rend. Soc. biol, 1939, 131: 827-30. ------ Action of toad venom on bleeding time. J. Am. M. Ass, 1942, 118: 1166 (Abstr.) ----- & Roskam, J. Adrenaline, adrenalone and mean bleeding time. J. Physiol, Lond, 1937, 90: Proc, 65-7 — Dishoek, H. A. E, & Jongkees, L. B. W. A new way to de- termine bleeding-time. Lancet, Lond, 1940, 1: 692.—Guzman, I. Las maneras de determinar la prueba de Duke. Rev. mex. biol, 1935, 16: 77-9.—Hugues, J. Temps de saignement moyen et interventions chirurgicales. C. rend. Soc, biol, 1939, 130: 75-7.—Ivy, A. C, Nelson, D, & Bucher, G. The standardization of certain factors in the cutaneous venostasis bleeding time technique. J. Lab. Clin. M, 1940-41, 26: 1812 22.—Lichzier, I., & Kleiman, S. [Clinical significance of determining the duration of hemorrhage by the ether method] Klin, med,'Moskva, 1938, 16: 647-52.—Roskam, J. Globulins et temps de saignement. C. rend. Soc. biol, 1921, 84: 844; 85: 18. ------ Les facteurs du temps de saignement. Ibid, 1922, 86: 298-300.------Temperature et temps de saignement. Ibid, 1933, 112: 1245-7. ------ Necessite n-\ g\imit&Je„la' notlon du temPs de saignement moyen. iiud, 114: 166-9. ----— Concentration en ions H et temps do saignement moyen. Ibid, 1934, 116: 335. ------ Calibre vasculaire et temps de saignement moyen. Ibid, 117: 481 — Hemorragies petites, mais plusieurs fois repetees ettemps de saignement moyen. Ibid, 1935, 118: 1610 ... . Hemorragies rapides et temps de saignement moyen! ibid., 788. ------ & Pauwen, L. Etude statistique du temps de saignement. Ibid, 1936, 123: 276-8.—Sezary, A. A propos du temps de saignement chez les sujets intoierants aux arsenobenzenes. Bull. Soc. med. hop. Paris, 1922, 3 ser 46- 862—Szecsi, B. Ueber die Bestimmung und die Fehler der Blutungszeit. Zschr. ges. exp. Med, 1931-32, 80: 331-40 — T"c|n*m!'„L- ,M- ,,The bleeding time. Am. J. Clin. Path, In-Zi 6:.,16°-71- Als° repr.—Vignali, A. L'indice di coagula- bilita e il tempo di stdlicidio sanguigno in ginecologia. Monit ostet. gin, 1934, 6: 344; 1936, 8: 438—Weil, P. E, Bocage, & Isch-Wall. Les variations du temps de saignement experi- mental chez la femme enceinte. C. rend. Soc. biol, 1922 87- 925-7. ---- Blood changes. Ltjbitz, K. *Resistenzbestimmungen von roten Blutkorperchen nach starken Blutver- lusten mit der Methode der partiellen Hamolyse [Munster] 33p. 8? Quakenbruck, 1933. ^ Theodorides, T. *La crise sanguine con- secutive aux hemorragies experimentales. 64p., 4p. 8? Par., 1934. Adolph, E. F., Gerbasi, M. J., & Lepore, M. J. The rate of entrance of fluid into the blood in hemorrhage. Am. J. Physiol, 1933, 104: 502-17.—Bonnet, V. De l'influence de l'hemorragie et de l'asphyxie sur le nombre des hematies dans le sang circulant des vertebres inferieurs. J. physiol. path, gen, 1929, 27: 735-40.—Brown, G. L., Miles, J. A. R. [et al.] The effect of haemorrhage upon red cell size and red cell distribu- tion. Brit. M. J, 1942, 1: 99-102.—Elman, R, Weiner, D. O, & Cole, W. H. Effects of a general anesthetic (sodium amytal) on the erythrocyte count following hemorrhage. Proc. Soc. Exp. Biol, N. Y, 1934-35, 32: 793-6.—Ferro, M. Ricerche sul rapporto tra fegato e variazioni della resistance emoglo- binica nelle grandi emorragie. Cult. med. mod. Pal, 1935, 14: 106-16.—Hoitink, A. W. J. H. Colloid-osmotic pressure of the plasma and composition of the blood after acute haemor- rhage and after haemorrhage followed by intravenous injection of a 0.9% NaCl-solution. Arch, neerl. physiol, 1939, 24: 169-93.—Ikeda, T. Untersuchungen iiber experimentellen Blutverlust; iiber die Blutviscositat nach acutem Blutverlust. Taiwan igakkai zasshi, 1932, 31: 41.—Isaacs, R, & Rosenman. L. D. Production of elongated, pencil, erythrocytes in chronic hemorrhage. Am. J. Path, 1941, 17: 451.—Mills, J. Effect of haemorrhage on the haemolytic titre of the serum of rabbits. J. Path. Bact, Edinb, 1925, 28: 579-89.—Nagaoka, H. Studies on restoration of the circulating blood after haemor- rhage; on the change in the haemoglobin-content of the blood, and in the colloid-osmotic pressure of the plasma of rabbits after bleeding. Jap. J. M. Sc, 1933-36, 3: Biophys, 395- 425.—Neumann, B. Experimentelle Beitrage zum Studium des Blutverlustes; die Veranderungen des Blutdrucks und der Erythrocytenzahl. Arch. klin. Chir, 1931, 164: 425-49. Die Veranderungen der Eiweisswerte und des osmo- tischen Druckes im Serum und das Auftreten junger Erythro- cyte!!. Ibid, 1932,172: 529-42— Robertson, J. D. The effect of haemorrhage of varying degree on blood and plasma volume, on blood sugar, and on arterial blood-pressure. J. Physiol, Lond, 1935, 84: 393-409.—Stabler, F. Blood counts after haemorrhage. Brit. M. J, 1935, 1: 1099.—■ Theodorides, T. La crise sanguine apres hemorragie; son mecanisme. Bull. Acad, med. Par, 1934, 3. ser. 111: 643-6 — Uzhansky, I. G. [Comparative-pathological evaluation of the process of erythrocyte disintegration during the post-hemor- rhagic period] Arkh. pat. anat, Moskva, 1940, 6: No. 4, 88-95.—Wallace, J, & Sharpey-Schafer, E. P. Blood changes following controlled haemorrhage in man. Lancet, Lond, 1941, 2: 393-5.—Winnett, M. H. Chemistry and physiology of blood as related to hemorrhage. Med. Woman J, 1925, 32: 31-7. ---- Blood chemistry] and metabolism. See also Blood sugar, high, post-hemorrhagic; Blood sugar, Variations, post-hemorrhagic, &c. Bloch, C. G. *Les hyperazotemies post- hemorragiques. 39p. 24cm. Par., 1939. Hawk, P. B. The influence of hemorrhage upon metabolism. 73p. 12? Easton, Pa., 1905. Aubertin, C, & Horeau, J. Azotemie post-hemorragique. Bull. Soc. med. hop. Paris, 1938, 3. ser, 54: 280-3.—Barnett, C. W, Jones, R. B, & Cohn, R. B. The maintenance of a normal plasma protein concentration in spite of repeated protein loss by bleeding. J. Exp. M, 1932, 55: 683-93 — Bennett, M. A. Some changes in the acid-base equilibrium of the blood caused by hemorrhage. J. Biol. Chem, 1926, 69: 675-92.—Black, D. A. K. Blood-urea and plasma chloride in HEMORRHAGE 538 HEMORRHAGE experimental haemorrhage. Lancet, Lond, 1940, 2: 618.— Boyd, E. M, & Stevenson, J. W. The regeneration of blood lipids following a single massive hemorrhage in rabbits. J. Biol. Chem, 1937-38, 122: 147-52. Also repr. ------ & Watkinson, E. A. Lipid content of blood leucocytes following hemorrhage in rabbits. Proc Soc. Exp. Biol, N. Y, 1937-38, 37: 653-5.—Calvin, D. B. Plasma volume and plasma protein concentration after severe hemorrhage. J. Lab. Clin. M, 1940-41, 26: 1144-8.—Carrier, E. B., Lee, F. W., & Whipple, G. H. Determination of plasma and hemoglobin volumes after unit hemorrhages under controlled experimental conditions, Am. J. Physiol, 1922, 61: 138-48.—Chevallier, A., & Tra- bouyer, L. Sur une modification physico-chimique des pro- teines du serum sanguin au cours de l'hemorragie. C. rend. Soc. biol, 1931, 107: 1129.—Cutting, W. C, & Cutter, R. D. Plasma protein regeneration after bleeding in the rat. Am. J. Physiol, 1935-36, 114: 204-6.—Dick, A. T. The effect of severe haemorrhage on the concentration of copper in the blood of sheep. Austral. J. Exp. Biol, 1939, 17: 271-4 — Dobriner, K, & Rhoads, C. P. The excretion of copropor- phyrin I following hemorrhage in dogs. J. Clin. Invest, 1938, 17: 105-8.—Elman, R. Concentration of serum protein follow- ing a single severe hemorrhage in the fasting dog. Proc Soc. Exp. Biol, N. Y, 1937-38, 37: 285-7. ------ Serum albumin regeneration following intravenous amino-acids (hydrolyzed casein) in hvpoproteinemia produced by severe hemorrhage. Ibid, 1940, 43: 14-6.—Fuss, H. Der Einfluss des Blut- verlustes auf den Blutmilchsaurespiegel. Klin. Wschr, 1934, 13: 917.—Harris, I. Blood-urea and plasma chloride in experi- mental haemorrhage. Lancet, Lond, 1940, 2: 795.—Hoitink, A. W. J. H. Colloid-osmotic pressure and lipoids of the blood- plaama in connection with the spleen after acute haemorrhage and after haemorrhage and subsequent injection of saline. Acta brevia neerl, 1938, 8: 104-7.—Junet, R, & Sciclounoff, F. Recherches experimentales sur l'azotemie post-hemorragique. Helvet. med. acta, 1939, 6: 542-7.—Lands, A. M, & Johnson, W. Distribution of body water following hemorrhage. Proc. Soc. Exp. Biol, N. Y, 1942, 49: 123-8— Mulinos, M. G. Hemorrhage hyperglycemia. Am. J. Physiol, 1928, 86: 70-3.—Nagaoka, H. Studies on restoration of the circulating blood after haemorrhage; on the restoration of the colloid- osmotic pressure of the blood plasma on rabbits after bleeding. Jap. J. M. Sc, 1936, 4: Biophys, 15-41.—Nagashima, T. Experimental studies upon the post-hemorrhagic lipemia Ibid, 1934-36, 4: Surg. Ac, 199.—Nitzescu, I. I, & Runceanu, I. L'influence de l'hemorragie sur le calcium et le phosphore mineral du sang. C. rend. Soc. biol, 1927, 97: 1109-11.— Rascanu, V., Busila, V, & Dorogan, D. Modifications phy- siques du serum sanguin dans les hemorragies massives; leur evolution au cours de l'effort reparateur. Ibid, 1939, 130: 1599-601.—Riegel, C. Formation of lactic acid in the body after severe hemorrhage. J. Biol. Chem, 1927, 74: 123 34.— Robinson, W, & Parsons, E. Hemorrhage and shock in traumatized limbs: total, free and bound water changes of blood and muscle. Tr. Chicago Path. Soc, 1931, 13: 515.— Saito, S, Kamei, B, & Tachi, H. Simultaneous determination of the epinephrine liberation and the sugar content and coagula- tion time of blood in the non-fastened, non-anaesthetized dogs after hemorrhage. Tohoku J. Exp. M, 1928, 11: 205-17.— Sapirstein, L. A, Ogden, E, & Southard, F. D, jr. Renin- like substance in blood after hemorrhage. Proc Soc. Exp. Biol, N. Y, 1941, 48: 505-8.—Selye, H, & Dosne, C. Changes in chemical composition of the blood coming from damaged tissues. Ibid, 47: 143-8.—Stevens, R. J. Urea nitrogen content of the blood following hematemesis and melena. J. Med, Cincin, 1940-41, 21: 381.—Stewart, J. D, & Rouke, G. M. Intracellular fluid loss in hemorrhage. J. Clin. Invest, 1936, 15: 697-702.—Swan, M. M. A delayed hyper-lacta- cidcmia following severe acute hemorrhage. Am. J. Physiol, 1941, 133: 466.—Tachi, H. Influence of haemorrhage upon the glycogen content of the liver and muscles of the rabbit. Tohoku J. Exp. M, 1926, 7: 197-206. ------ & Saito, S. Significance of the augmented epinephrine secretion after haemorrhage in dogs upon the simultaneous occurrence of hyperglycaemia. Ibid, 1928, 11: 218-32.—Volinets, I. T. [Regeneration of blood proteins after a grave hemorrhage] J. m6d, Kiev, 1938, 8: 783-90. ---- Blood volume, and its restitution. See also Acacia gum; Blood transfusion, and its subheadings. Andrievsky, B. U. [Regeneration of the blood after sub- stituting the blood loss with salt solutions] Nov. khir. arkh, 1937, 37: 560-7. ------ [Morphological changes in the parenchymatous organs after injection of mediums, sub- stituting the loss of blood] Ibid, 568-79.—Bricker, F., Su- ponitzkaja, F., & Tscharni, A. Zur Frage der Blutersatz- fliissigkeit bei schweren Blutverlusten. Zschr. ges. exp. Med 1925-26, 48: 451-71.— Ebert, R. V., Stead, E. A., jr, & Gibson, J. G., II. Response of normal subjects to acute blood loss, with special reference to the mechanism of restoration of blood volume. Arch, Int. M, 1941, 68: 578-90.—Hi rota, K. On the restitution of the blood fluid after haemorrhage J Biochem, Tokyo, 1928, 9: 87-102.—Holzbach, E. P6rdida y reemplazo de la sangre. Rev. med. germ. iber. amer, 1932, 5: 128-33.—Hunter, W. Blood replacement after haemor- rhage, with an illustrative case. Brit. M. J, 1936, 2: 537- 646. Also Lancet, Lond, 1936, 2: 132.—Kallius, H. U. Die Verweildauer der gebrauchlichen BlutersatzflUssigkciton, insbesondere transfundierten Serums, nach grossen Blutver- lusten im Tierexperiment. Deut. Zschr. Chir, P.I29, 220: 216-38.—Konrich. Zur Frage der Blutersatzmittel. Arch" klin. Chir, 1935, 182: 459-88.—Naegeli, T, & Korth. i. Experimentelle Blutmengenbestimmung nach akubin Hint' verlust und Wiederersatz durch Eigen- und Fremdblut be- ziehungsweise Tutofusin- und phvsiologischer Kochsalzldsung Helvet. med. acta, 1936, 3: 109-13.—Nagaoka, H. Studies ori restoration of the circulating blood after haemorrhage; on the change in the blood volume and in the colloid osmotic pressure of the plasma in rabbits after the shed blood volume is restored by introducing various solutions. Jap. J. M. Sc 1936, 4: Biophys, 199-211.—Perumov, N. D. [Experimental data on Gumm arabic injections in hemorrhages] Vest, khir 1926, 8: No. 23, 54-9.—Taylor, N. B, & Waters, E. T. Isin- glass as a transfusion fluid in haemorrhage. Canad. M. Ass. J, 1941, 44: 547-54.—Tonkes, E. [Increase in tho quantity of circulatory blood following sudden hemorrhage] Ned tschr. geneesk., 1934, 78: 2061-70. ---- Cardiovascular system. Barry, A. The effect of exsanguination on the heart of the embryonic chick. J. Exp. Zool, 1941, 88: 1-15.—Chauchard, A, Chauchard, B, & Barry, D. T. Effects of haemorrhage on the vascular nervous mechanism. Brit. J. Exp. Path 1931, 12: 190-9.—Clerc, A, & Quinquaud, A. Complexe' eiectrique du coeur exsangue; transformation monophasi'e apres I'ablation de la paroi ventriculaire gauche. Ann. physiol Par, 1938, 14: 500-3.—Eismayer, G, & Schmitt, F. Experi- mentelle Untersuchungen iiber die Fdrderleistung des Herzens und die Utilisation des Blutes bei akuten Blutverlusten Arch. exp. Path, Berl, 1933, 170: 719-32.—Gaikuni, S. g! [Capillaroscopy and its significance in grave hemorrhages] Sovet. khir, 1934, 6: 756-64.—Gedda. L, & Lupo, M. Ricerche radiografiche sulle modificazioni cardio-polmonari che seguono lo svuotamento dei serbatoi sanguigni. Minerva med. Tor 1933, 24: pt 2, 454-6.—Radnai, P. [Electrocardiogram of anoxemia in acute hemorrhage] Orv. hetil, 1935, 79: 921-3.— Silfverskiold, B. P. Ueber das Verhalten der Kapillaren bei Blutverlust. Skand. Arch. Physiol, Berl, 1938, 7«J: 23I-1L— Tomaszewski, W. [Effect of hemorrhage and intravenous injections on the circulatory system] Nowiny lek, 1936, 48: 238-44.—Volterra, M. Widerstandsfiihigkeit der Capillarwand und Capillarblutungen; neue anatomische Beobachtungen. Klin. Wschr, 1928, 7: 1464-6. ---- Clinical aspect. Aloin, H., & Noel, R. Les hemorragies en oto-rhino-laryngologie. 227p. 8? Par., 1932. Cecha, A. H. Oto-rhino-pharvngeal hemorrhages. U. S. Nav. M. Bull, 1930, 28: 335-43.—Echemendia, J. D. La hemorragia como comp!icaci6n en los casos de cirugia dental. Rev. med. cubana, 1929, 40: 461-8.—Foley, C. B. Hemorrhage. Am. J. Orthodont, 1941, 27: Oral Surg, 701-3.—Stout, P. S. Oto-rhinological hemorrhage and some methods of control. Laryngoscope, 1928, 38: 71-9.—Vazquez Barriere, A. Hemor- ragias intra-oculares y hemorragias menfngeas. Rev. otoneur, B. Air, 1928, 3: 339-51.—Weill, P. E. Apropos des hemor- ragies interessant les oto-rhino-laryngologistes. Progr. med. Par, 1927, 42: 364—9. ------ Les hemorragies en pratique dentaire. Odontologie, Par, 1931, 69: 245-53. ---- Death. Domenici, F. Sulla morte per emorragia; il comportamento del cuore neUa morte per emorragia. BoU. Soc ital. biol. sper, 1935, 10: 52. ------ La quantity di sangue contenuta nei visceri neUa morte per emorragia. Ibid, 42: 691-3. ----- Sulla morte per emorragia. Haematologica, Pavia, 1935, 16: 1021; 1936, 17: 1. Also Arch, antrop. crim. Tor, 1937, 57: Suppl, 357-61.—Hansen, J. L. [On the frequency of fatal hemorrhages due to cancer of the stomach and cirrhosis of the liver] Nord. med, 1939, 2: 1820-4.—Ionkin, G. A. [Limes mortis in acute hemorrhages in normal and in tired animals] Arkh. pat. anat, Moskva, 1939, 5: No. 3, 71-3.—Lcites, S. M. [Distribution of blood in the vessels of the brain and other organs in acute, fatal hemorrhages] Arkh. biol. nauk, 1936, 41: 133-43.—Lukens, J. A. Fatal type of hemorrhage foUowing throat infections. Ohio M. J, 1929, 25: 879-82.—Missildine. W. H. Exsanguination; a classification and analysis of 33 cases. J. Iowa M. Soc, 1941, 31: 59-64.—Moss. H. K. Factors influencing mortality in cases of hematemesis and melena. J. Med, Cincin, 1940-41, 21: 383-6.—Roltsch, H. Der Tod durch Verblutung ins Gewebe. Deut. Zschr. Chir, 1927, 201: 122-5.—Sasaki, K, & Kim, K. Studien uber den bis zum Tode fortgesetzten protrahierten Blutverlust (ein Beitrag zur Baetz- nerschen Vergiftungshypothese als die Todesursache der chronischen Verblutung) Keijo J. M, 1932, 3: 457-91 — Sasaki, K., & Muraoka, T. Histologische Veranderung der verschiedenen Organe. Ibid., 1933, 4: 358-66, 2 pl.—Scott, L. D. W. Fatal haematemesis and melaena. Lancet, Lond, 1937, 2: 435-7.—Spadaro, G. Ricerche sperimentali sulla morte per dissanguamento; le lesioni visceraU nella morte per dissanguamento acuto. Zacchia, 1939, 2. ser, 3: 525-37.— Tzanck, A. De la mort par hemorragie. BuU. Soc. obst. gyn. Paris, 1929, 18: 600-2. HEMORRHAGE 539 HEMORRHAGE .---- Etiology. Buckman, T. E. Atypical pathologic hemorrhage in early life Am. J. M. Sc, 1928, 175: 307-12.—Cashman, B. Z. Adolescent hemorrhage. Atlantic M. J, 1925-26, 29: 222-4.— Haden R. L. Pathologic hemorrhage. Proc. Interst. Post- grad. M. Ass. N. America, 1932, 7: 325-30. Also Ohio M. J, 1933 29: 487-92.—Kessel, L. Bleeding of benign origin. J. Am. M. Ass, 1931, 97: 1058-60. Also repr.—Lapicirella, V. Eziologia, fisiopatogenesi e cura delle emorragie. Riv. clin. med, 1927, 28: 777-87. ---- Extravasated blood. See also Ecchymosis; Hematoma, &c. Clerc, W. O. Quelques donnees sur les extravasats physiolo- giques et le r61e histologique des erythrocytes extravas4s. Bull. histol. appl, Lyon, 1938, 15: 277-91.—Heissmeyer, K. Unter- suchungen iiber die Veranderung des in Korperhohlen ergos- senen Blutes. Deut. Zschr. Chir, 1931, 231: 227-36.—Seeliger, P. Das Schicksal von Blutergiissen in verschiedenen Geweben unter besonderer Berucksichtigung der Fragen der Verkalkung und Verknocherung; zugleich ein Beitrag zur experimentellen Erforschung der Myositis ossificans circumscripta. Arch. kUn. Chir, 1927, 147: 405-50. ---- Forensic aspect. Breitenecker, L. Innere Verblutung aus seltenen natur- Uchen Ursachen. Beitr. gerichtl. Med, 1935, 13: 110-21.— Krauland, W. Eigenartiger Magenbefund bei Tod durch Blutverlust. Deut. Zschr. gerichtl. Med, 1939, 32: 48-50 — Ponsold, A. Die Hydramie als agonale Reaktion des Blutes beim Verblutungstod. Ibid, 1940, 34: 164-76 (microfilm)— Reuter, K., & Delbanco, E. Ueber Suffusionsblutungen der Haut in gerichtUch-medizinischer Hinsicht. Derm. Wschr, 1924, 79: 1572-7. ---- gynecological., and obstetrical. See also Abortion; Labor; Menstruation; Pregnancy; Uterus, Hemorrhage; and names of primary diseases, and conditions. Goczy, L. [Causes and treatment of hemorrhages in gyne- cology] Gyogyaszat, 1933, 73: 753-8.—Herrmann, E. Aetio- logie, Diagnostik und Therapie der intraperitonealen Blutungen beim Weibe. Wien. khn. Wschr, 1929, 42: 1229-34.—Klein. Intraperitoneale Blutungen beim Weibe und ihre Diagnostik. Chirurg, 1928-29, 1: 829-37.—Kup, J. von. Die endokrin bedingte, konstitutioneUe Bluterbereitschaft bei Frauen und ihre Behandlung. Deut. med. Wschr, 1938, 64: 1005.— Massimi, G. L'emorragia del secondamento in rapporto al fattori etiologici. Atti Soc. ital. ostet, 1909, 15: 442-7.— Runge, H. Die Therapie der sogennanten funktionellen Blutungen. Ber. ges. Gyn, 1936-37, 33: 1-9—Scipiades, E. [Hemorrhages in gynecology] Orv. hetil, 1933, 77: 889-94.— Sundelin, G. Experimental investigations into ovarian changes in hemorrhagic anemia. Acta obst. gyn. scand, 1940, 20: 16-24.—Szenteh, I. [Abdominal hemorrhages in gynecology] Orv. hetil, 1935, 79: 793-7. Also Verh. ungar. arztl. Ges, 1935, 7: 25.—Tonkes, E. [Sudden hemorrhages] Ned. tschr. verlosk, 1936, 39: 87-95.—Turpault. L'hormone m&le chez la femme specialement dans les hemorragies. Gynecologie, 1939, 38:281-7. ---- Hematopoietic system. Stratjss, A. *Ueber die akute posthaemor- rhagische Milzschwellung. 50p. 8? Bonn, 1928. Barrv, D. T, & Torrens. D. S. On the regeneration of blood after haemorrhage. J. Physiol, Lond, 1926-27, 62: 192-7 — Hughes, J. H., & Latner, A. L. Chlorophyll and haemoglobin regeneration after haemorrhage. Ibid, 1936, 86: 388-95. ----- Aetioporphyrin and haemoglobin regeneration after haemorrhage. Ibid, 1937, 89: 403-6.—Levin. O. A. [Morpho- logical reaction of the hemopoietic organs after acute hemor- rhages] Vest, khir, 1932, 26: 96. Also Beitr. path. Anat, 1931-32, 88: 349-61, pl.—Schij«dt. E. A standard for estimat- ing blood-regeneration after haemorrhage. Acta med. scand, 1938, 96: Suppl. 89, 169-72. ------ Observations on blood regeneration in man; the rise in reticulocytes in patients with hematemesis or melena from peptic ulcer. Am. J. M. Sc, 1938, 196: 632-41.—Ukita. K. Vergleichende Studien iiber die Behandlungen bei experimentellen Anamien beim Kaninchen; fiber die Histologic des ReticuloendotheUalsystems bei toxischen AnSmien und bei Verblutungsanamien; insbesondere iiber die Histologic der Leber und der Milz. Okayama igakkai zasshi, 1935, 47: 3129.—Vedel, Giraud, G. [et al.] Les reactions sanguines posl^hemorragiques: une observation de reaction myeioblastique passagere d'une remarquable intensite. Arch. mal. coeur, 1926, 19: 303-10. Also Bull. Soc. sc. med. biol. MontpelUer, 1925-26, 7: 375-84. ----Hemostatic system. See also Blood coagulation. Donati, G. S. Sul comportamento del tempo di emorragia e della retrazione del coagulo in condizioni normali, patologiche e sperimentaU (splenectomia; raggi X; somministrazioni di Ca) Boll. Soc. med. chir, Pavia, 1928, 1131-45.—Dreyfuss, A. La exploraci6n racional de la funcion hemostittica; frente al diag- n6stico y el tratamiento de las hemorragias patol6gicas. Arch. lat. amer. card, Mex, 1940, 10: 43-60.—Glosman, O. S. [Variability of the rate of blood coagulation in acute hemor- rhages] Arkh. pat. anat, Moskva, 1941, 7: 57-68. ---- Historical data. Hunter, R. H. Haemorrhage; a historical survey. Ulster M. J, 1934, 3: 33-40.—Talos epuise par la perte de son sang; chancelle et tombe; peinture d'un cratere antique. Aesculape Par, 1939, 29: 210.—Taylor, R. C. Secondary haemorrhage in 1582; a royal case history. Brit. M. J, 1939, 2: 1103. ---- internal. See also Viscera, Hemorrhage; also under names of internal organs, tissues, and cavities. Cesana, G. Leucocitosi come sintoma di emorragie interne. Osp. maggiore, Milano, 1929, 17: 13.—Czyhlarz, E. Die Behandlung der Blutungen in der inneren Medizin. Wien. med. Wschr, 1928, 78: 1279-82.—Graff, E. Der Schmerz als Symptom innerer Blutungen. Arch. klin. Chir, 1926, 140: 608-12.—Hofmann, W., & Messerli, W. Ein Beitrag zur Therapie innerer Blutungen beim Rind. Schweiz. Arch. Tierh, 1937, 79: 51-60.—Kressin, V. K. [Therapy of hemorrhages of internal organs] Odess. med. J, 1929, 4: 544-52.—Lattes, A. Hemorragie interne; accident exceptionnel de la pratique journaliere. Rev. stomat. Par, 1938, 40:160.—Mandelstamm, A. Eine vereinfachte Technik der Pyramidonprobe zum Nachweis innerer Blutungen. Deut. med. Wschr, 1926, 52: 830.—Matthews, T. E. An obscure case of internal haemor- rhage. Brit. M. J, 1930, 1: 111.—Meyer-Wildisen, R. Ueber innere Blutungen. Schweiz. med. Wschr, 1934, 64: 917-9.— Redon, H. Diagnostic d'une grande hemorragie interne. Vie med, 1926, 7: 2131.—Szabo, L [Internal hemorrhage] Orvoskepzes, 1939, 29: 808-19.—Witte, D. H. Diagnosis and treatment of internal hemorrhage. Wisconsin M. J, 1934, 34: 460-6. ---- occult. Altmann, M, & Kallner, A. Die Hamatoporphyrinprobe in der Diagnostik okkulter Blutungen. Arch. Verdauungskr, 1929, 45: 169-72.—Boas, I. Ueber provokatorische Erzeugung okkulter Blutungen. Deut. med. Wschr, 1926, 52: 349-51. ------Neue Fortschritte auf dem Gebiete der okkulten Blutungen. Arch. Verdauungskr, 1930, 47: 347-61.—Halfen, S. S. [CUnical significance of the test for occult hemorrhages] Ter. arkh, 1935, 13: 94-100.—Haurowitz, F. Der Abbau des Blutfarbstoffes im Verdauungstrakt des gesunden Menschen; ein Beitrag zur Kenntnis der okkulten Blutung. Arch. Ver- dauungskr, 1931, 50: 33-46.—Jiirgensen, E. Okkulte Blu- tungen. Verh. Deut. Ges. Kreislaufforsch, 1934, 7:283—Ka- lisch, H. Zur Frage der provokatorischen Erzeugung okkulter Blutungen (nach Boas) Deut. med. Wschr, 1926, 52: 1776.— Madsen, S. [Occult haemorrhages] Med. rev, Bergen, 1916, 33: 477-85.—Snapper, I, & van Creveld. S. [Occult hemor- rhage] Ned. tschr. geneesk, 1927, 71: pt 2, 401; 525.— Spanir, F. L. [Preparation of the patient before examination of occult hemorrhages] Dnipropetr. med. J, 1929, 8: 168-73. ---- Pathogenesis. See also Capillaries, Fragility; Diapedesis; Psychoneurosis; Wound, &c. Darlington, P. J., jr. Auto-hemorrhage in Tropidophis semicinctus. BuU. Antivenin Inst. America, 1927, 1: 59.— Galant, J. S. Reflektorische Blutungen bei Tier und Mensch; Beitrag zur vergleichenden Reflexologie. Zool. Anz, 1926, 66: 193-6.—Greenway, D. J. Un nuevo procedimiento para la obtenci6n de fen6menos hemorrrigicos experimentales. Dia med, B. Air, Ed. espec, 1939, 165.—Gridnev, A. P., & Tzve- nieva-Matcharaschvili, S. S. [Influence of constitution on degree of hemorrhage] Vrach. delo, 1927, 10: 414.—Manville, I. A., Brodie, J. L, & Moore, C. U. The production of cerebral and visceral hemorrhage in the young rat; an experimental study; preliminary report. Northwest M, 1926, 25: 205.— Petersen, W. F. Spontaneous hemorrhage and the meterologi- cal environment. Illinois M. J, 1940, 77: 325-9.—Pirogova, L. A. [Correlation between the height of venous pressure and the degree of the hemorrhage] Vest, otorinolar, 1940, No. 4, 81-4.—Schultz, W. AUgemeines zur Genese und Therapie von Blutungen. Deut. med. Wschr . 1934, 60: 1791.—Valerie, A. As hemorragias ex-vacuo. Brasu med, 1929, 43: 225. ---- Physiopathology. Hatieganu, V. Contribution a l'etude physio-pathologique des grandes hemorragies. 52p. 8? Par., 1932. Alsina, D., & Piulachs, P. Papel de los senos carotfdeos en la resistencia de la presion sanguinea a la hemorragia. Medicina, Madr, 1941, 9: 224-8.—Brooks, C. McC. Com- pensation for blood loss in chronic spinal cats. Am. J. Physiol.. 1935 113: 19 ------ The reaction of chronic spinal animals to hemorrhage. Ibid, 1935-36, 114: 30-9.—Carmona, h HEMORRHAGE 540 HEMORRHAGE Sul comportamento del sistema reticolo-endoteliale nelle emorragie. Cult. med. mod. Pal, 1931, 10: 253-60.—Cullen, T. S. Bleeding; a danger signal. J. Missouri M. Ass, 1929, 26: 103-5.—Danilov, N. V, n the water content of the tissues of the body after trauma and aftei hemorrhage. Arch. Surg, 1931, 22: 638-48.—Hertzman, A. B, & Gesell, R. Hemorrhage and ventilation. Proc. Soc. Exp. Biol, N. Y, 1926-27, 24: 263-8.—Pozzan, A. Emorragie e sistema reticolo-endoteliale. Pathologica, Genova, 1933, 25: 200-8.—Rein, H, & Rossier, R. Die Abhangigkeit der vaso- motorischen Blutdruckregulation bei akuten Blutverlusten von den thermoregulatorischen Blutverschiebungen im Ge- -amtkreislaufe. Zschr. Biol, 1929, 89: 237-48.—Rossle, R. Das Verhalten der Milz nach Blutungen. Verh. Deut. path. Ges, 1928, 23: 89-97 [Discussion] 122; 569.—Roome, N. W. Effects of hemorrhage and of transfusion on the blood flow in an extremity. Arch. Surg, 1939, 38: 692-7.—Saito, S. Effect of haemorrhage upon the rate of liberation of epine- phrine from the suprarenal gland of dogs. Tohoku J. Exp. M, 1928, 11: 79-115.— Schlossberg, T., & Sawyer, M. E. M. Studies of homeostasis in normal, sympathectomized and ergotaminized animals; the effect of hemorrhage. Am. J. Physiol, 1933, 104: 195-203.—Tachi, H. Influence of hemor- rhage upon the epinephrine (Folin) content of the suprarenals of the rabbit. Tohoku. J. Exp. M, 1928, 10: 409-19 — Van Liere, E. J, Northup, D. W, & Sleeth, C. K. The effect of acute hemorrhage on absorption from the small intestine. Am. J. Physiol, 1938, 124: 102-5.—Wildova, A. [Two in- teresting pathologic anatomical cases] Bratisl. lek. listy, 1935, 15: 1219-23. ---- secondary. Graciani Tello, F. Hemorragias secundarias; normas generales. Rev. espan. med. cir. guerra, 1941, 7: 113-9.— Krishnan, R. G. Secondary haemorrhage. Madras M. J, 1937, 17: 205-12.—Materzanini, A. Shock post-operatorio interpretato eoine emorragia secondaria. Clin, ostet, 1932, 34: 593-6.— Vilesov, S. P. [Secondary hemorrhages following wounding; data from tire field hospital] Nov. khir. arkh, 1941, 49: 257-62.—Waugh, W. G. Secondary haemorrhage. In Surg. Modern Warf. (Bailey, H.) Edinb, 1940-41, 328-32. ---- Sequelae. See also Anemia, posthemorrhagic; Blindness, posthemorrhagic; Erythropenia, &c. Alves Simoes. Troubles visuels graves consecutifs k des pertes de sang. Rev. path, comp. Par, 1922, 22: 91-5.— Astakhova, A. P. [Ophthalmological observations while dogs are bleeding to death and during resuscitation] Vest. oft, 1941, 18: 149-53.—Clemmensen, V. [Sudden disorders of vision following hemorrhage] Hospitalstidende, 1937, 80: 1173-80.—Goldfeder, A. E. Ueber einen durch Bluttrans- fusion geheilten Fall von schweren Sehstorungen nach Blut- verlust. Zschr. Augenh, 1934-35, 85: 31-5. ------& Rapo- port, K. N. Ueber einen durch Bluttransfusion geheilten Fall von schweren Sehstorungen nach Blutverlust. Klin. Mbl. Augenh, 1934, 93: 666-71.—Guitard, I. Observation de cachexie hemorrhagique. J. med. Toulouse, 1864, 4. ser, 3: 33-42.—Hermann, P. Troubles visuels post-hemorragiques. Bull. Soc. opht. Paris, 1936, 805-9. Also Arch. med. Angers, 1937, 41: 34-9.—Ibanez Puiggari, M. Trastornos visuales por hemorragias graves. Rev. espec, B. Air, 1929, 4:1340-7.— Terson, A. Les troubles visuels aprds les pertes de sang. Rev. gen. opht, Geneve, 1921, 35: 489-95.—Tidy, H. L. Loss of vision following haemorrhage. Brit. M. J, 1941, 1: 774-6. Also Clin. J, Lond, 1941, 70: 185. ---- Sequelae, nervous and mental. Legris, P. P. A. *Les troubles nerveux d'origine centrale post-hemorragiques. 67p. 24cm. Lille, 1934. Rogery, A. Contribution a l'etude des accidents nerveux post-hemorragiques; sur un cas de coma apres hematemese. 28p. 24cm. Par.. 1939. Schneider, L. Contribution a l'etude des troubles mentaux consecutifs a ties pertes de sang. 70p. 8? Par., 1935. Worms, R. *Les accidents nerveux con- secutifs aux pertes de sang; etude clinique et experimentale. 207p. 8? Par., 1931. Hadden, S. B. Neurological symptoms in posthemorrhagic secondary anemia. Ann. Int. M, 1935-36, 9: 1572-7.— Klosovsky, B. N. [Histological changes in the central nervous system in complete temporary bleeding of the animal] Arkh biol. nauk, 1941, 62: No. 2. 101-11. -Lagt-ze, P. Los crises convulsives de l'anemie aigue post-hemorragique. Progr. med. Par, 1938, 749.—Langeron, I, Accidents nerveux post-hemorragiques. J. med. chir. Par., 103."), 106: 201-6.— Worms, R. A propos de quelques troubles nerveux consecutifs aux pertes de sang; le role des hemorragies dans la pathogenic des accidents de la ligature carotidienne. J. chir. Par, 1033 41: 215-28. ---- Shock, and collapse. See also Collapse; Shock. Abramson, B. P. [On the duration of the period of pronenesj to shock following blood-loss] Arkh. biol. nauk, 1940, 58: 51-7.—Blalock, A. Mechanism and treatment of expcrimenlil shock; shock following hemorrhage. Arch. Surg, 1927, 15: 762-98.------ Shock; further studies with particular reference to the effects of hemorrhage. Ibid, 1934, 29: 837 57. ------ Traumatic shock and hemorrhage. South M. J, 1934, 27: 126-30. ------ Acute circulatory failure as exemplified bv shock and haemorrhage. Surg. Gyn. Obst 1934, 58: 551-66. ------ Shock and hemorrhage. Bull" N. York Acad. M, 1936, 12: 610-22. ------ & Brooks. B. Shock with particular reference to that due to haemorrhage and trauma to muscles. Ann. Surg, 1934, 100: 728-33.— Briiner, H. Experimentelle Untersuchungen uber den Ent- blutungskollaps. Verh. Deut. Ges. Kreislaufforsch, 1938, 11; 281-3.—Bucci, P. Contributo al trattamento dello shock emorragico con l'uso di soluzioni salino-gommose. Boll. Sec. ital. biol. sper, 1927, 2: 965-72.—Ooonse, G. K, Foisie, P. S. [et al.] Traumatic and hemorrhagic shock, experimental and clinical study. N. England J. M, 1935, 212: 647-03 — Domenech-Alsina, F. Etudes sur la physio-pathologie du shock: role de l'adrenaline dans le maintien de la pression arterielle apr£s hemorragie. Arch, internat. physiol, 1937, 45: 298-309.—Fischer, G. Ce que pratiquement le medecin doit savoir du traitement des chocs hemorragique et traumatique en campagne. Concours med, 1940, 62: 159.—Fraser, J. Shock and haemorrhage. In War & Doctor (Mackintosh, J. M.) 2. ed, Lond, 1940, 25-40.—Freeman, N. E. Haemor- rhage in relation to shock; experimental effect of intravenous injections of saline, gum acacia, and blood on the rate of adrenal secretion resulting from haemorrhage. Ann. Surg, 1935, 101: 484-93. Also in Surgery (Ravdin, I. S.) Phila, 1935, 484-93. —----Shaffer, S. A. [et al.] The effect of total sympathectomy on the occurrence of shock from hemorrhage. ,1. Clin. Invest, 1938, 17: 359-68.—Fullerton, A. Shock and haemorrhage. Tr. Ulster M. Soc, 1919-20, 20-56- Govier, W. M, & Greer, C. M. Studies on shock induced by hemor- rhage; effect of thiamin on survival time. J. Pharm. Exp. Ther, 1941, 72: 317-20. ------ Studies on shock induced by hemorrhage; effect of thiamin on disturbances of carbo- hydrate metabolism. Ibid, 321-30.—Harkins, H. N, & Roome, N. W. Concealed hemorrhage into tissues and its relation to traumatic shock. Arch. Surg, 1937, 35: 130-9.— Huffman, L. D. Solution of acacia and sodium chloride in hemorrhage and shock: effects of intravenous administration. J. Am. M. Ass, 1929, 93: 1698-702.—Johnson, C. A. Ephe- drine sulphate in treatment of acute shock from trauma or hemorrhage; clinical use. Ibid, 1930, 94: 1388-90. Also repr. ------ A study of neo-synephrin hydrochloride in the treat- ment of acute shock from trauma or hemorrhage. Surg. Gyn. Obst, 1936, 63: 35; 1937, 65: 458.—Johnson, G. S, & Blalock, A. Experimental shock; a study of the effects of the loss of whole biood, of blood plasma and of red blood cells. Arch. Surg, 1931, 22:626-37. Also repr.—Katz, L. N. Hemor- rhage and shock. In Pract. Libr. M. & S, 1932, 1: 1163- 81.—Kennedy, J. W. Differential diagnosis between hem- orrhage and shock following abdominal surgery. Med. Rec, N. Y, 1934, 140: 420.—Krogh, A. [Shock and loss of blood] Hospitalstidende, 1921, 64: [K0benh. Med. Selsk. Forh.] 70-3.—Lehman, E. P., & Amole, C. V. The function of the spleen in the retardation of shock from hemorrhage; an experimental study. Surgery, 1938, 4: 44-50.—Metivet. A propos du traitement du choc hemorragique. Mem. Acad. chir. Par, 1940, 66: 526-9. Also Presse med, 1940, 48: 560.—Moon, V. H. Early recognition of shock and its differ- entiation from hemorrhage. Ann. Surg, 1939, 110: 260-72. ------ Morgan, D. R. [et al.] Similarities and distinctions between shock and the effects of hemorrhage. J. Am. M. Ass, 1941, 117: 2024-30. Also Surgery, 1941, 10: 530.—Morgan, E>. R., Lieber, M. M., & McGrew, D. Certain physiological differences between shock and hemorrhage. Am. J. Path., 1941, 17: 604-6.—Neumann, B. Shock, collapse and hemor- rhage. Harefuah, Tel Aviv, 1941, 20: 71.—Parsons, E. Experimental shock and hemorrhage. Tr. Ass. Physicians Mayo Clin. (1929) 1930, 10: 106-8.—Plunkett, J. E. Shock and haemorrhage; physiological considerations. Canad. J. Comp. M, 1940, 4: 243-9.—Price, P. B., Hanlon, C. R. [et al.] Experimental shock; effects of acute hemorrhage in healthy dogs. Bull. Johns Hopkins Hosp., 1941, 69: 327-62—Ranso- hoff, J. L., & Mendelsohn, S. N. The treatment of surgical shock and postoperative hemorrhage. J. Med, Cincin, 1932, 12: 637-41.—Roome, N. W., Keith, W. S, & Phemister, D. B. Experimental shock: the effect of bleeding after reduction of the blood pressure by various methods. Surg. Gyn. Obst, 1933, 56: 161-8.—Schnedorf, J. G., & Orr, T. G. Oxygen therapy in shock due to hemorrhage. Ibid, 1941, 73: 495-7,— HEMORRHAGE 541 HEMORRHAGIC DIATHESIS Sheehan, H. L. Subendocardial haemorrhages in shock. Lancet, Lond, 1940, 1: 831.—Traumatic shock and hemor- rhage. War Med, Par, 1918, 2: 770-89.—Werle, J. M., & Cosby R. S. Initiation of shock through loss of blood or plasma. Am. J. Physiol, 1941, 133: 487.—Zunz, E, & Govaerts. P. Recherches sur le collapsus circulatoire post-hemorragique. Arch, internat. physiol, Liege, 1921-22, 17: 113-37. ---- Surgical aspect. See also Hemostasis. Biidinger, K. Keine Tupfer und Mullkompressen wahrend der Operation, kein unnotiges Wundwischen! Zbl. Chir, 1935, 62: 2197-203.—Gosset, A. De la perte de sang au cours des operations. Mem. Acad, chir. Par, 1940, 66: 303; 405.— Guillemot, L., Bloch, A. [et al.] Prophylaxie des hemorragies post-operatoire par les extraits hepatique et gastrique. Ann. otolar. Par, 1936, 297-301.—Hallas, E. A. Secondary haemor- rhage after diathermy operation. J. Lar. Otol, Lond, 1928, 43: 277.—Jara, R. Autohemotherapy in the prevention of opera- tive and post-operative hemorrhages. Month. Bull. Bur. Health, Manila, 1939, 19: 177-84.—Mann, F. C, Herrick, J. F. [et al ] The effect on the blood flow of decreasing the lumen of a blood vessel. Surgery, 1938, 4: 249-52.—Rubio y Gali, F. La profilaxis de las hemorragias en los actos quiriirgicos. Congr. hisp. portug. cirug, 1898, 1. Congr, 46-53.—Schon- bauer, L. Zur Vermeidung postoperativer Blutungen. Chirurg, 1933, 5: 609.—Stajano, C. El post-operatorio: las hemorragias de las primeras horas. An. Fac. med, Montev, 1926, 11: 148-65.—Weil, P. E. Les hemorragies post-operatoires; comment les prevoir et les prevenir? J. urol. med. Par, 1934, 38: 289-97.—Yates, A. L. Methods of estimating the liability to post-operative haemorrhage from unsutured wounds. Proc. R. Soc. M, Lond, 1927-28, 21: sect. lar. otol, 86-90. Also J. Lar. Otol, Lond, 1928, 43: 781-5. ---- Therapeutic use. See Bloodletting; Venaesection. ---- Treatment. See also Blood transfusion; Emergency; First aid; Hemostasis. Barthelemy, M. Le traitement des hemorragies graves et des etats de shock chez I'homme. Bull. Soc. nat. chir. Par, 1929, 55: 1050-2.—Cubitt, A. W. The value of persisting with drip blood transfusion in severe prolonged haemorrhage. Lancet, Lond, T937, 1: 864.—Domenici, F. Sulla morte per emorragia; l'influenza deH'adrenalina e della morfina sulla circolazione di ritorno. Boll. Soc. ital. biol. sper, 1935, 10: 693.—Drenkhahn, R. Erinnerungen aus meinem arztlichen Leben. Med. Welt, 1934, 8: 1769.—Fitzgerald, L. M. Causes and treatment of hemorrhage. J. Am. Dent. Ass, 1937, 24: 615-20.—Ionkin, G. A. [Experiments in prolonging life in cases of fatal losses of blood] Voen. san. delo, 1935, 64-71.—■ Jones, F. A. Haematemesis and melaena; observations on the use of continuous drip transfusions. Brit. M. J, 1939, 1: 915- 8.—Kerboul, M. Hemorragies graves en pratique dentaire, traitement curatif et preventif. Rev. stomat. Par, 1932, 34: 282-90.—Negovsky, V. A, Makarichev, A. L. [et al.] [Resusci- tation of dogs following clinical death resulting from loss of blood] Arkh. pat. anat, Moskva, 1939, 5: 29-49. Also Bull. biol. med. exp. URSS, 1938, 6: 358-62— Normet, L. Traite- ment des hemorragies experimentales chez le chien par un serum artificiel k base de citrates. C. rend. Acad, sc, 1929, 188: 354-6.—Petrov, I. R., & Strukova, E. I. [Resuscitation of animals after fatal loss of blood] Vest, khir, 1937, 51: 230- 46.—Roskam, J. Adrenaline, ephedrine et temps de saigne- ment moyen. C. rend. Soc. biol, 1934, 115: 724-6.------& Lhoest, C. Action de quelques medicaments sur la durie du temps de saignement. Ibid, 1933, 112: 1248-50.—Rostock, P. Blutstillung und Blutersatz. Med. Welt, 1939, 13: 1331-3 — Sintomi e cura di malattie mediche e chirurgiche d'urgenza; emorragie. Progr. ter, Milano, 1906, 169-76.—Stacy, H. S. Twenty years after: haemothorax, pulmonary hemorrhage, and retroperitoneal haemorrhage; shock. J. R. Army M. Corps, 1940, 74: 172.—Tzanck, A, & Charrier, J. Traitement des hemorragies graves de differentes formes. C. rend. Acad. sc, 1930, 190: 226-8.—Van Liere, E. J, Northup, D. W, & Vaughan, P. E. The effect of enteral absorption of fluids on the recovery of the blood pressure after severe hemorrhage. Am. J. Digest. Dis, 1940, 7: 71.—Winkelbauer, A. Experi- mentelle Untersuchungen iiber Wiederbelebung nach Verblu- tung. Deut. Zschr. Chir, 1935, 245: 1-15. HEMORRHAGIC anemia. See Anemia, hemorrhagic. HEMORRHAGIC diathesis. See also Diathesis; Hemophilia; Scurvy, &c; also in 3. ser. Purpura. Einhorn, F. *Les diatheses hemorragiques. 48p. 8? Geneve, 1930. Kretz, J. Die hamorrhagischen Diathesen 89p. 8? Lpz., 1930. Nygaard, K. K. Hemorrhagic diseases 320p. 25cm. S. Louis, 1941. Wagner-Brendler, G. *Hamorrhagische Diathesen [Erlangen] 28p. 8? Nurnb., 1930. Ainsworth, M. L. The purpuras. Ohio M. J, 1937, 33: 849-53.—Beard, M. F. The hemorrhagic diathesis. Kentucky M. J, 1942, 40: 4-7.—Bommel van VIoten, W. J. van [Hemor- rhagic diatheses] Geneesk. gids, 1928, 6: 801; 825; 833.— Brugsch, H. Blut, Blut- und Bluturrgskrankheiten. Mschr. Kinderh, 1935-36, 64: 403; 1938, 72: 295.—Buinewitsch, K. The hemorrhagic diathesis. Urol. Cut. Rev, 1934, 38: 474- 9.—Capps, R. B. Hemorrhagic diseases. In Rev. med. (Boshes, B.) Chic, 4. ed, 1940, 147.—Carpenter, G, & Allen, J. G. Hemorrhagic diathesis. Proc Inst. M. Chicago, 1942, 14: 54.—Cooley, T. B, & Sanford, H. N. Round table con- ference on blood disorders characterized by bleeding. J. Pediat, S. Louis, 1933, 3: 916-36.—Cristau, X. M. Les etats hemorragipares. Arch. med. pharm. mil, 1927, 87: 637- 705.—Diatesis hemorragicas. Dfa med, B. Air, 1941, 13: 1040.—Di Guglielmo, G. Le diatesi emorragiche. Riforma med, 1927, 43: 1092-5. ------ Le malattie emorragiche. In Emopatie, 2. ed. (Ferrata, A.) Milano, 1935, 2: pt 2, 971- 1038.—Dreyfus, A. Les purpuras. Progr. med. Par, 1936, 1450-9.—Freeman, E. T. Purpura, haemophilia and poly- cythaemia. Med. Press & Circ, Lond, 1940, 204: 14-9.— Galdi, F. Le diatesi emorragiche. Riforma med, 1926, 42: 505-14.—Goldstein, H. I. Hemorrhagic blood dyscrasias; symptomatology, diagnosis and treatment, with historical notes. Med. Rev. of Rev, 1934, 40: 647-51.—Goldstein, H. J. Discrasie emorragiche del sangue. Policlinico, 1935, 42: sez. med, 501-8. Also repr.—Goyena, J. R. Purpuras. Sem. med, B. Air, 1929, 36: 241-7.—Haemorrhagic (The) state. Brit. M. J, 1937, 2: 707.—Hammer, F. Hamorrhagische Krankheiten. In Handb. Haut & Geschlkr. (A. & G. Alexander) Berl, 1928, 6: T. 2, 512-83. Also Zbl. Haut Geschlkr, 1928, 27: 449-63.—Holten, C. [Hemorrhagic diathesis] Ugeskr. laeger, 1937, 99: 269-78.—Johannessen, C. Om purpura-sygdomme. Norsk mag. Isegevid, 1918, 79: 1209; 1336.—Johanning, L. Die hamorrhagischen Diathesen. Fol haemat, Lpz, 1930, 43: 223-38.—Jurgens, R. Ueber Blutungsl bereitschaft. Med. Welt, 1938, 12: 190-4.—Konchalovsky M. P. [Hemorrhagic diathesis] In his Klin, lekts, Moskva, 1937, 3:-4: 268-78.—Kracke, R. R. The purpuric diseases, J. M. Ass. Georgia, 1941, 30: 498.—Lavsky, G. K. [Hemor- rhagic diathesis and manifestations of biblical bloody sweat] Sovet. klin, 1932, 17: 48-50.—Madsen, S. T. [Haemorrhagic diathesis] Med. rev, Bergen, 1926, 43: 167-76.—Marrella, V. Diatesi emorragiche: purpora. Riv. med, 1929, 37: 54- 6.—Morawitz, P. Hamorrhagische Diathesen. Verh. Deut. path. Ges, 1930, 25: 32-45.—Ogilvie, A. G. Haemorrhagic disease. Clin. J, Lond, 1932, 61: 304; 18.—Oyarzabal, E. de. Enfermedades de la piel hemorragicas. Siglo med, 1931, 87: 441-9.—Pangaro, J. A. Purpuras y di&tesis hemorragicas. Dia med, B. Air, 1938, 10: 602; 619.—Pignatari, F. I. Porpore emorragiche; emofilia. Rass. ter. pat. clin, 1930, 2: 359-80.—■ Renaux, E, & Alechinsky, A. Les purpuras et phenomenes hemorragiques. Bruxelles med, 1936-37, 17: 149-58.—■ Rosenthal, N. Hemorrhagic diatheses; thrombocytopenia, thrombasthenia, capillary (hemorrhagic) toxicosis, hemophilia and thrombocythemia. In Handb. Hemat. (Downey, H.) N. Y, 1938, 1: 501-51.—Rubnitz, A. S. Purpuras. Nebraska M. J, 1932, 17: 482.—Schmidt, M. B. Referat iiber die hamorrhagischen Diathesen. Verh. Deut. path. Ges, 1930, 25: 10-32.—Schuepbach, A. Hamorrhagische Diathesen. Helvet. med. acta, 1940^1, 7: 547-50.—Schultz, W. Ueber hamorrhagische Diathesen. Zschr. iirztl. Fortbild, 1936, 33: 187-9.—Strumia, M. M. Hemorrhagic diseases. In Cyclop. Med. (Piersol-Bortz) Phila, 1939, 2: 799-807.—Tidy, H. L. Haemorrhagic diseases. In Brit. Encycl. M. Pract. (Rolleston, H.) Lond, 1937, 6: 138-54. Also in Treat. Gen. Pract, 2. ed, Lond, 1938, 2: 252-69.—Tixier, L. Syndromes hemorragiques. In Traite med. enfants (Nobecourt & Babonneix) Par, 1934, 2: 884-916.—Weissenbach, R. J, & Basch, G. Les purpuras. Monde med, 1932, 42: 33-50.—Willebrand, E. A. v, & Olin, J. [Recent experiences with hemorrhagic diathesis] Nord. med, 1939 2: 1743-51.—Witts, L. J. The haemorrhagic states. Brit'M J, 1937, 2: 689-92. Also Lancet, Lond, 1937, 2: 261. Also Ulster M. J, 1937, 6: 253-5. —----Capon, N. B. [et al.] The haemorrhagic states. Brit. M. J, 1937, 2: 227. ---- Allergic type. See also subheadings Henoch-Schonlein type; Infection, &c.; also Allergy, cutaneous. Alexander, H. L., & Eyermann, C. H. AUergic purpura. J Am M Ass, 1929, 92: 2092-4. Also repr.—Barthelme, F L. Allergic purpura. J. Allergy, 1929-30, 1: 170.—Bartley, C H D & Bell, A. D. C. The allergic basis of primary pur- pura "in chUdren. Lancet, Lond, 1936, 2: 359-61.—Cimellaro, R. Sopra un caso di porpora anafilattoide. Riv. clin. pediat, 1934 32: 1389.—Diamond, J. Anaphylactoid or allergic purpura. J. Pediat, S. Louis, 1936, 8: 697-703—ElMs, R. W. B. Allergic purpura. Proc. R. Soc. M, Lond, 1937-38, 31: 768-70.—Eyermann, C. H. Allergic purpura. South. HEMORRHAGIC DIATHESIS 542 HEMORRHAGIC DIATHESIS M J, l!':i"i, 28: 3-11-5.—Goldstein, E. Allergic purpura. Internat. i Im., 1930, 10. ser, 4: 186-201.—Kostal. O. A, & DeBacker, L. J. Anapln lactoid pur[iiira. Nebraska M. J, 1935, 20: 175-7.—Kourilsky, R, CJuillot, M, & Ong Sian Gwan. Etudes sur le mecanisme des lesions hemorragiques d'origine aUergique et anaphylactique. Rev. immun. Par, 1938, 4: 230-62.—Lanzenberg, Walter & Ullmo, M. Purpura et 6rytheme purpurique post-serique. Bull. Soc fr. derm. syph, 1928, 35: 856-8.—Lookeren Campagne, J. van [Ana- phylactoid purpura] Ned. tschr. geneesk, 1939, 83: 3693- 700.—Peters, G. A, & Horton, B. T. AUergic purpura with special reference to hypersensitiveness to cold. Proc. Mayo CUn, 1941, 16: 631-6.—Salazar Mallen, M., & Gonzalez Guzman, I. Purpura aiergica. Arch. lat. amer. card, Mex, 1938, 8: 99-103.—Thomas, J. W, & Forsythe, J. R. Allergy in relation to purpura. J. Lab. Clin. M, 1940-41, 26: 1105- 10.—Weil, P. E. Un cas de purpura anaphylactique chronique k poussees subintrantes chez une femme porteuse d'un angiome congenital. Bull. Soe. fr. derm, syph, 1933, 40: 683-9. —---- Deuxieme presentation d'un cas de purpura anaphylactique. Ibid, 1282-4.—Westrienen, A. van. [Allergic purpura] Mschr. kindergeneesk, 1937-38, 7: 297-303.—Wintrobe, M. M. Anaphylactoid purpura. In Cyclop. Med. (Piersol-Bortz) Phila, 1939, 2: 822-4. ---- Angiodermitis. Sztokhamer, S. *L'angiodermite purpurique pigmented des membres inferieurs; a propos de 58 observations nouvelles. 129p. 25cm. Lyon, 1938. Cappelli, E. Emosiderosi micropapuloide purpurica diffusa da dermo-capiUarite generahzzata deUa cute con abnorme fraguitA vasalc Gior. ital. derm, sif, 1937, 78: 399-417, 2 pl.—Favre, M. Sur une forme clinique rare de l'angiodermite purpurique et pigmentee des membres inferieurs; l'angio- dermite aigue, extensive, hyperalgique; contribution k l'etude des ceUulo-dermites purpuriques des membres inferieurs. J. med. Lyon, 1936, 17: 361-8.—Mguebrow, M. G, & Kachin- ski, A. A. Un cas de purpura chronique punctiforme kera- tosique des extr6mites. Ann. derm, syph. Par, 1934, 7. ser, 5: 1076-84.—Schwarzmann, J. M. Sur la dermatose pig- mentee et purpurique de membres inferieurs, et le pigment h6mosiderique dans la peau; donnees cUniques, histologiques et experimentales. Acta derm, vener, Stockh, 1930, 11: 1-37. ---- Atypical form. Luders, L. *Zur Kenntnis der haemor- rhagischen Diathesen insbesondere der atypischen Falle. 32p. 8? Rostock, 1931. Angeleri. C. Di un rara forma emorragica familiare. Gior. Accad. med. Torino, 1934, 97: pt 2, 58-61.—Becht, P. E. Purpura of unusual type. J. Cut. Dia. incl. Syph, 1919, 37: 470.—Braestrup, P. W. [Transitory hemorrhagic diathesis of unknown origin in a boy, 2 years of age] Ugeskr. laeger, 1939, 101: 610.—Geiger, A. J., & Evans, A. G. Atypical hereditary hemorrhagic syndromes. Internat. Clin, 1938, n. ser, 2: 135-57.—Giflin, H. Z. Unusual types of hemorrhagic disease. Tr. Ass. Am. Physicians, 1927, 42: 195-208. Also Am. J. M. Sc, 1928, 175: 44-9.—Gillespie, J. B. A familial hemorrhagic condition of an unusual type. Illinois M. J, 1935, 68: 83-5.— Gj0rup, E. [Atypical hemorrhagic diathesis] Hospitalsti- dende, 1935, 78: 299-305.—Kreiner, W. Ein FaU von Hamo- phUoidie. Deut. Zschr. Chir, 1933, 238: 774-6.—Lifshitz, L. S. ICertain clinical data on pecuhar forms of hemorrhagic diathesis] Vrach. delo, 1935, 18: 427-32.—Little, W. D, & Ayers, W. W. Hemorrhagic disease; famiUal bleeding tendency of unusual type with splenomegaly, affecting and transmitted by both males and females. J. Am. M. Ass., 1928, 91: 1251. ---- Blood. Alvarez de Toledo & Valero, R. Estudio hematol6gico comparative de cuatro casos de sindromes hemorr&gicos agudos y mortales. Actual, med, Granada, 1940, 16: 287- 301.—Archi, A, & Samek, E. L'anisocitosi neUe diatesi emorragiche. Haematologica, Pavia, 1936, 17: 121-33.— Arneth, J. Ueber das quaUtative Verhalten der Thrombo- cyten und Leukocyten bei der Hamophilie und bei der essen- tieUen Thrombopenie. Fol. haemat, Lpz, 1937, 57: 166-93.— Chevallier, P. Les syndromes sanguins des maladies hemor- ragiques. Nutrition, Par, 1933, 3: 661-72.—Jiirgens, R. VerteUung der Eiweisskorper im Blut bei hamorrhagischen Diathesen. Deut. Arch. klin. Med, 1931, 171: 378-90.— Rallo. A. Le variazioni ematologiche negU stati emorragici; variazioni globulari numeriche e della formula leucocitaria. Morgagni, 1929, 71: 2029; 2237.—Rosenthal, N. The blood picture in purpura. J. Lab. Clin. M, 1927-28, 13: 303-22. ---- Blood platelet deficiency, qualitative. See subheadings Thrombasthenia; Thrombo- pathy; also Hemophilia. ---- Blood platelet deficiency, quantitative. See subheading Thrombocytopenic purpura1 also Blood platelet, Deficiency; also names of primary diseases, poisons, &c. ---- Cardiovascular system. See also Capillaries, Toxicosis. Bermuth. von. Ueber Kapillarbeobachtungen bei Hiimo- phdie und anderen hamorrhagischen Diathesen. Korbl allg. iirztl. Verein. Thiiringen, 1926, 55: 171.— Dinlder, g! Ueber einen Fall von hamorrhagischer Diathese; zugleich ein Beitrag zur Frage des Status dysvascularis (Bohnenkamn) Zschr. khn. Med, 1936-37. 131: 800-5.—Ellmer, H. Kapll- larmikroskopische Untersuchungen bei den hamorrhagischen Diathesen (PriidilektionssteUen der spontanen Blutungen im peripheren Gefassabschnitt) Deut. Arch. klin. Med, 1927, i56: 80-8.—-Frontall, G. Der Capillarfaktor bei hamorrhagi- schen Diathesen. Mschr. Kinderh, 1937, 68: 220.—Herrmann, G. R. Purpura as a cardiologic problem. Med. Clin, n! America, 1927, 11: 719-52.—Jiirgensen, E. Capillarmikro- skopische Beobachtungen bei Purpura; ein Beitrag zur Lehre von der hamorrhagischen Diathese. Deut. Arch. klin. Med, 1933, 175: 534-44.—Lapiccirella, V. Alterazioni morfologiche e disturbi funzionaU capillari nella patogenesi delle emorragie diatesiche. Riv. clin. med, 1928, 29: 431-40.—Lukomsky, P. [Capillaries in hemorrhagic diathesis] Klin, med, Moskva' 1928, 6: 32-9.—Osier, W. Note on the relation of the capillary blood-vessels in purpura. Lancet, Lond, 1909, 1: 1385.— Parade, G. W, & Franke, H. Elektrokardiogramm-Verande- rungen bei hamorrhagischer Diathese. Zschr. klin. Med 1938-39, 135: 107-14.—Strobl, A. CapUlaruntersuchungen bei einem Fall von hamorrhagischer Diathese. Mschr. Kinderh , 1931, 49: 24-7.—Tidy, H. L. Hamrorrhagic diathesis; angio- staxis. Lancet, Lond, 1926, 2: 365-9.—Weissenbach, R. J, & Basch, G. Maladie des capiUaires sanguins et syndromes vaso-moteurs. In Traite derm. (Schulmann, E.) 1933, 2: 65-99.—Zahorski, W. [CUnical investigations of the functions of the capillaries of the skin; clinical value of the ampullar reaction in manifest hemorrhage] Polska gaz. lek, 1938, 17: 960-4. ---- Casuistics. Bianchi, A. E. Consideraciones sobre un caso de purpura. Rev. As. m6d. argent, 1932, 45: 1566-74.—Burnford. A case of purpura. West London M. J, 1927, 32: 140.—Cases (Two) of purpura. S Thomas Hosp. Rep, Lond. (1903) 1904, n. ser, 32: 69-73.—Chesnutt, J. Purpura, with report of cases. J. Arkansas M. Soc, 1914-15, 11: 215.—Claremont, C. C. Case of purpura. Proc. R. Soc. M, Lond, 1909-10, 3: Sect. Stud. Dis. ChUd, 163.—Coke, H. Two interesting cases of purpura. Brit. M. J, 1931, 1: 535-7, pl.—Dohne, E. Ein FaU von Purpura. KUn. Wschr, 1937, 16: 825-8.—Donath, F. Ueber einen FaU von symptomatischer Purpura. Wien. med. Wschr, 1927, 77: 1704.—Freezer, C. R. E. Four cases of gastric haemorrhage due to the haemorrhagic diathesis; hsema- temesis and purpura; splenectomy; death from perforation of duodenal ulcer. Guy's Hosp. Rep, Lond, 1928, 78: 465-9 — Gardstam, R. [Case of hemorrhagic diathesis] Sven. lak. tidn, 1932, 29: [Sven. foren. inv. med. forh.] 166.—Gougerot, H, & Salin, H. Purpura localise de l'avant bras, k topographie nerveuse, provoque par une constriction des nerfs au niveau du coude, chez un tuberculeux. BuU. Soc. fr. derm, syph, 1910, 21: 213.—Haden, R. L, & Schneider, R. W. The hemorrhagic diathesis; a review of 310 cases. Am. J. Clin. Path, 1941, 11: 263-74.—Haxthausen, H. [PecuUar case of purpura] Hos- pitalstidende, 1936, 79: [Dansk derm, selsk. forh.] 28 — Kasteele, R. P. van de [Purpura] Mschr. kindergeneesk, 1933, 2: 326-36.—Kisel, A. A. [Severe purpura in a girl 12 years old, ending in death] Sibirsk. vrach. gaz, Irkutsk, 1911, 4: 5-7.—Laureati-Fabiano, L. Contributo aUa casistica deUe porpore. Gazz. osp, 1931, 52: 1480-91.—Lawrence, J. S. Two cases with purpura. Med. CUn. N. America, 1929, 13: 155-63.—Lewis, G. E., & Macnab, G. H. A case illustrating the coexistence of the arthritic and aUmentary forms of pur- pura. Lancet, Lond, 1931, 1: 1238.—Merrill, T. C. A case of purpura. J. Am. M. Ass, 1909, 52: 1402.—Moraes, B. A proposito de um caso de purpura. Med. contemp, Lisb, 1915, 33: 34.—Rispal & Lavaur. Sur un cas de purpura k topographie radiculaire. Toulouse med., 1913, 2. ser., 15: 81-5.—Robson, W. M. Case of purpura. Proc. R. Soc. M, Lond, 1912-13, 6: Sect. Stud. Dis. Child, 200-2.—Sakar, P. P. [Rare case of purpura in a girl 2 years 10 months old] Sibirsk. vrach. gaz, Irkutsk, 1913, 6: 98-100.—Sanchez de Ribera. Sobre un caso de purpura. Pediatria espafi, 1917, 6: 305-8.— Sibley, W. K. Case of purpura. Proc. R. Soc. M, Lond, 1913-14, 7: Derm. Sect, 184. Also Brit. J. Derm, 1914, 26: 202.—Signa, A. Osservazioni cUniche su alcuni casi di malattie emorragiche. Pediatria (Riv.) 1932, 40: 569-86.—Teglkamp, O. [Case of hemorrhagic diathesis] Ugeskr. laeger, 1937, 99: 669-72.—Tropeano, G. Un caso di porpora. Gior. inter- naz. sc. med, 1911, n. ser, 33: 982-6.—Wohlstein, E. Ein ungewohnlicher FaU von Purpura. Derm. Wschr.. 1933, 96: 783-8. HEMORRHAGIC DIATHESIS 543 HEMORRHAGIC DIATHESIS ---- Classification, and types. Dreyftjss, P. [n6e Filderman] _ *A propos des hemorragies observees en pratique dentaire; essai de classification des maladies hemorragiques. 52p. 8? Par., 1932. Becks H. Zur Nosologie der hsemorrhagischen Diathesen. 4cta med. scand, 1925, 62: 474-520.—Catel, W. Einteilung der Blutungsubel im Kindesalter. Kinderarztl. Prax, 1939, 10- 372-6.—Chevallier, P. Classification des purpuras. Rev. beige sc. med, 1938, 10: 113-25.—Creveld, S. van [Rare hemorrhagic diatheses] Mschr. kindergeneesk, 1934, 3: 351- 66, 6 pl.—Davidson, L. S. P. Discussion on purpuric condi- tions in man and animals; classification and treatment of the .purpuras. Proc R. Soc. M, Lond, 1936-37, 30: 715-23.— Demuth, F. Fehlt uns nicht ein Eigenschaftwsort zu Purpura? Derm. Wschr, 1937, 105: 892.—Drouet, G. Les maladies hemorragipares diathesiques (hemophilic hemogenie, hemo- geno-hemopbilie) J. med. Paris, 1926, 45: 972-6.—Freezer, C. R. E. Melaena and purpura, splenectomy, recovery. Guy's Hosp. Rep, Lond, 1928, 78: 469.—Giordano, J. J. Purpuras de Schonlein-Henoch y Werlhof. Prensa med. argent, 1937, 24: 192-201.—Ivanova, A. F. [Case of reticulo-endotheliosis in a "family, affected by hemorrhagic diathesis] Klin, med, Moskva, 1941, 19: No. 4, 112-4.—Jurgens, R. Systematik der hamorrhagischen Diathesen. Schweiz. med. Wschr, 1941, 71: 1494, passim.—Kisel, A. A. [On the classification of so-called purpura in children] Kazan, med. J, 1930, 26: 1012-9.— Koranyi, S. [Classification and diagnosis of haemorrhagic diathesis] Orv. hetil, 1927, 71: 16; 47.—Lozner, E. L., Jolliffe, L. S, & Taylor, F. H. L. Hemorrhagic diathesis with prolonged coagulation time associated with a circulating anticoagulant. Am. J. M. Sc, 1940, 199: 318-27, pl.—Maragarot, J, Rimbaud, P, & Ravoire, J. Quelques aspects cliniques et histo-patho- logiques des hematodermies k forme tumorale. Montpellier med, 1939, 3. ser, 15: 211-28.—Marcondes, J. R. As doencas hemorragicas, doenca maculosa de Werlhof e purpura vascular de Schonlein-Henoch, estudo cUnico, com apresentacao de 5 casos. Hospital, Rio, 1939, 15: 87-125.—Mettier, S. R. Classification and treatment of the hemorrhagic states. J. Am. M. Ass, 1937, 108: 83-6. Also repr.—Nevzat Cankat [A rare case of hemorrhagic diathesis in myeloid purpura] Askeri sihhiye mecmuasi, 1939, 68: 9-18.—Nordin. Zwei Falle " von urticariellem blasenfdrmigem Hautausschlag zusammen mit Purpura. Acta derm, vener, Stockh, 1935, 16: 110.— Pepin, J. R, Lefebvre, R. [et al.] Les grands syndromes hemorragiques. Union med. Canada, 1942, 71: 251-6.— Petrini-Galatz. Erytheme purpurique, analgesique, polyurie, polydipsie; guerison. Roumanie med, 1893, 1: 105>-15.— Piney, A. A peculiar form of pupura. Brit. J. Derm. Syph, 1933, 45: 309, pl.—Polak Daniels, L. lets over purpura haemorrhagica (anaphylactoide purpura, thrombopenieen, thrombasthenieen) Ned. tschr. geneesk, 1933, 77: 8-24.— Puech, A. A propos de la classification des syndromes hemor- ragiques. Montpellier med, 1931, 53: 69-79.—Rake, G. W. Preliminary note on a case of haematemesis and spontaneous ecchvmoses. Guy's Hosp. Rep, Lond, 1928, 78: 470-3.— Rodecurt, M. Ein besonderer Fall von universeller Purpura beim Neugeborenen. Zbl. Gyn, 1928, 52: 241-4.—Schultz, W. Einteilung, Verlauf, Entstehung und Behandlung der Pur- puraerkrankungen unter Berucksichtigung neuerer Gesichts- punkte. Arch. Kinderh, 1920, 78: 52-71.—Stepanov, P. N. [Classification of hemorrhagic diathesis] Vrach. delo, 1937, 19: 257; 1938, 20: 13.—Strasser, U. Welche Arten von hamor- rhagischer Diathese unterscheidet man und welche Therapie ist bei diesen zu empfehlen? Aerztl. Prax, Wien, 1932, 6: 199.— Tzanck, A, & Dreyfuss, A. Intolerance et dystrophic endothe- lio-plasmatiques. Presse med, 1932, 40: 1223.—Waldheim, S. von. Die Blutknotchenkrankheit (Purpura haem. papulosa et pustulosa) Med. Klin, Berl, 1915, 11: 945.—Wintrobe, M. M. Miscellaneous forms of purpura. In Cyclop. Med. (Piersol- Bortz) Phila, 1939, 2: 825. ---- Clinical aspect. Cordeiro de Farias, R. Estudo clfnico das purpuras. Fol. med, Rio, 1933, 14: 415-9.—Cowen, S. O. The haemorrhagic diathesis. Austral. J. Dent, 1929, 33: 283-5. Also Brit. J. Dent. Sc, 1929, 74: 327-31. ------■ A cUnical lecture on the haemorrhagic diathesis. Melbourne Hosp. Clin. Rep, 1932, 3: 21-8, pl —Evans, W. H. Notes on some haemorrhagic condi- tions. Liverpool Med. Chir. J. 1929, 37: 40-6—Jagic, N. von, & Klima, R. Zur Klinik und Therapie der hamorrhagischen Diathesen. Munch, med. Wschr, 1934, 81: 433-7.—LaRue, C. L. Laryngology in relation to disease of the hematopoietic system, especially purpura and agranulocytosis. J. Am. M. Ass, 1931, 97: 920-2.—Mead, S. V. Hemorrhagic diseases. Internat. J. Orthodont, 1928, 14: 789-94.—Pierquin. Fasci- cule d'observations sur I'hemaceiinose; Montpellier, 1820 (a review) Observ. sc. med, 1822, 44: 282- 9.—Risak, E. Klinik und Therapie der hamorrhagischen Diathesen. Aerztl. Prax, Wien, 1935, 9: 322-5.—Tidy, H. L. Remarks on the haemor- rhagic diathesis. Brit. M. J, 1928, 1: 583-6. ■---- Diagnosis. See also Blood coagulation; Blood platelet, Count; Prothrombin. Aubertin, C. Signe du lacet negatif chez des malades en pleme eruption purpurique. Bull. Soc med. hop. Paris, 1940,56: 3. ser, 56: 375.—Bahuelos Garcia, M. Sopre la frecuencia con que en la prdctica corriente se desconoeert las purpuras. Inform. med, Valladolid, 1927, 4: 91-5.—Bertrand, A. Role du labora- toire dans les hemorragies. Union med. Canada, 1942, 71: 246-50.—Chevallier, P. Sur le diagnostic des syndromes hemorragiques constitutionnels; k propos d'un cas peu frequent de diathese hemorragique. J. med. chir. Par, 1930, 101: 672- 7.—Diggs, L. W. Laboratory tests used in diagnosis and management of hemorrhagic diseases. In Textb. Clin. Path. (Kracke, R. R.) Bait, 1938, 162-86, illus— Glanzmann, E. Ueber Diagnose und Therapie der hamorrhagischen Diathesen. Kinderarztl. Prax, 1930, 1: 69-79.—Jaso, E. La prueba de la purpura provocada en los nifios. Arch, espan. pediat, 1931, 15: 720-8.—Kracke, R. R. The diagnosis and treatment of the purpuric diseases. South. M. J, 1941, 34: 56-61.—Moloney, W. C. Clinical classification and diagnosis of hemorrhagic diatheses. N. England J. M, 1941, 225: 933-6.—Poinso, R. Les syndromes hemorragiques, leur diagnostic, leur inter- pretation. In Actual, med. chir. (Marseille Fac. med.) 1933, 2. ser, 71-88.—Pollet, L. Le temps de saignement: sa valeur diagnostique et pronostique dans les etats hemorragipares chroniques. Gaz. hop, 1923, 96: 1651-7.—Riccitelli, L. Sulla diagnosi di porpora a localizzazione splancnica. Athena, Roma, 1934, 3: 1-9.—Rosenthal, N. Diagnosis and treatment of the hemorrhagic diseases. J. M. Soc. N. Jersey, 1927, 24: 405-9.— Suarez, R. M, & Benitez Gautier, C. Metodos de laboratorio en el estudio de las diatesis hemorragicas. Bol. As. med. Puerto Rico, 1941, 33: 94-103.—Watkins, C. H. Diagnosis and treat- ment of hemorrhagic diathesis. Minnesota M, 1939, 22: 824-8.—Witts, L. J, & Hobson, F. C. G. Analysis of haemor- rhagic states with snake venom and lecithin. Brit. M. J, 1940, 2: 862-4. ---- Diagnosis, differential. Budelmann, G. Zur Differentialdiagnose der hamorrha gischen Diathesen. Derm. Wschr, 1939, 109: 1193-6. Also Zschr. arztl. Fortbild, 1939, 36: 519; 553.—Catel, W. Diffe- rentialdiagnose der hamorrhagischen Diathesen. Mschr. Kinderh, 1937, 68: 181-202—Fitz-Hugh, T, jr. Differential diagnosis of hemorrhagic conditions; an outline. Med. Clin. N. America, 1926, 10: 175-84.—Geraci, J. E, & Jorgensen, E. A differential diagnosis of purpura. Marquette M. Rev, 1939- 40, 4: 184-92.—Heck, F. J. The differential diagnosis of diseases with hemorrhagic manifestations. Texas J. M, 1940- 41, 36: 536-9.—Kammerer. Ueber Differentialdiagnose und Therapie der hamorrhagischen Diathesen. Miinch. med. Wschr, 1927, 74: 88.—Naegeli, O. Differentialdiagnose der hamorrhagischen Diathesen. In his Differ. Diagn. inn. Med, Lpz, 1936-37, 48-59.—Philipp, E. [Differential diagnosis of hemorrhagic diathesis] Polska gaz. lek, 1929, 8: 791-3.— Rosenow, G. Differentialdiagnose und Therapie der hamor- rhagischen Diathesen. Zschr. iirztl. Fortbild, 1933, 30: 96-101. ---- Endocrine aspect. Druckrey, H. *Der Einfluss von Ver- anderungen im Gleichgewicht der Sexualhor- mone auf Blutgerinnung und Blutungsver- haltnisse. 19p. 8? Lpz., 1932. Also Endokrinologie, 1933, 12: Heidel, H. *Beobachtungen iiber endokrin bedingte hamorrhagische Diathesen. 35p. 23cm. Berl., 1938. Patrtjnky, M. *Ovarialfunktion und haemor- rhagische Diathese. 16p. 8? Greifsw., 1936. Kup, G. Endokrine Aetiologie und Therapie der hamor- rhagischen Diathese. Frankf. Zschr. Path, 1938, 52: 473-9. & Pazar, D. [Effect of auto-hemorrhagic hormone demonstrated by Kup in colutoid] Gyogy&szat, 1938, 78 537-9. Etiology. See also names of primary diseases, poisons, &c. as Cachexia; Cancer; Melilotus, Poisoning, &c. Morel, P. *Traumatisme et purpura. 86p. 8? Par., 1913. Beiglbock, W. Ueber die Bedeutung hamorrhagischer Diathesen bei occulten Carcinomen. Zschr. klin. Med, 1933, 124- 411-9—David, W. Ueber Purpura-Erkrankungen bei Frauen. Med. Klin, Berl, 1926, 22:1755.—Davis, E. Chronic purpura, with orthostatic factor, following trauma. Proc R. Soc. M, Lond, 1939-40, 33: Clin. Sect, 331.—Duque, M. Etio-patogenia e tratamento das hemorragias medicas mais frequentes. Horamed, Rio, 1939, 3: No. 10, 9-20.—Kindler, W. Zur Frage der Purpura traumatica. Miinch. med. Wschr, 1928, 75: 823.—Leone, A. Sull'importanza del fattore eredo- luetico nelle diatesi emorragiche del bambini. Atti Soc. sc. med. natur. CagUari, 1934, 36: 533-47.—Madison, F. W , & Snuier. T. L. Etiologic factors in purpuric states. Tr. Am. Ther. Soc, 1936, 36: 27. Also Wisconsin M. J., 1938, 37: HEMORRHAGIC DIATHESIS 544 HEMORRHAGIC DIATHESIS 636-40.- Medda, E. Le sindromi emorragiche nei bambino; etio-patogcnesi. Kiv. clin. pediat.. 1929, 27: 674-98— Niigeli. Hamorrhagische Diathese. .lahrkurs. arztl. Fortbild, 1930, 21: H. 3, 10-20.—Nagy, G. Leber das Problem des hamor- rhagischen Svndroms und seine konstitutionellen Beziehungen. Deut. med. Wschr, 1928, 54: 740.—Pakozdy, K. [Relation between kidney diseases and hemorrhagic diathesis] Orv. hetil, 1930, 74: 1-4.—Risak, E. Konstitution und hamor- rhagische Diathesen. Wien. klin. Wschr, 1934, 47: 1192-6 — Rissotto, A. A, & Natin, I. Sobre las didtesis hemorrdgicas; hemogenia, tuberculosis y hormonas ovstricas. Prensa med. argent, 1937, 24: 2279-83.—Weinberger, W. Ueber einen Fall von Purpura seltenerer Aetiologie in der stomatologischen Praxis. Zschr. Stomat, 1932, 30: 1227-9. Fibrinogen deficiency. See also Fibrinogen; Liver, Disease, &c. Castex, M. R, Pavlovsky, A, & Gorodner, A. El fibrinogeno en las diatesis hemorragicas. Bol. Acad. nac. med. B. Aires, 1939, 895-900.—Glanzmann, E, Steiner, H, & Keller, H. Konstitutionelle angeborene Afibrinogenamie und Fibrinopenie im Kindesalter. Schweiz. med. Wschr, 1940, 70: 1243; 1261.— Nissen, N. I. [Diathesis haemorrhagica fibrinopenica essen- tialis] Hospitalstidende, 1938, 81: 879-84—Schonholzer, G. Die hereditare Fibrinogenopenie. Deut. Arch. klin. Med, 1939, 184: 496-510.—Wolff, J. Verblutungstod wegen Fi- brinmangels. Jahrb. Kinderh, 1936, 3. F, 98: 33-7. ---- Forensic aspect. Denison, R. Purpura hemorrhagica following electric injury (medico-legal aspect) Clin. M. & S, 1933, 40: 636.— Morgan, A. C. Hemorrhagic purpura as a possible medico- legal condition. Philadelphia Gen. Hosp. Rep, 1913, 9: 79.— Schrader, G. Zur forensischen Bedeutung hamorrhagischer Diathesen im Kindesalter. Deut. med. Wschr, 1938, 64: 633-5. ---- Hematopoietic system. Schultz, W. Aplasien und hamorrhagische Diathesen. Med. Welt, 1932, 6: 1849-52. ------ Aplasien mit be- sonderer Beriicksichtigung der haemorrhagischen Diathese. Ibid, 1938, 12: 113-7. Also Sitzber. Internat. hiimat. Tagung (1937) 1938, 1. Congr, 122-34. ---- Hemostatic system. See also Blood coagulation, Mechanism. Naumann, W. *Experimentelle und klinische Untersuchungen iiber die Morphologie und Agglutinationsfahigkeit der Thrombozyten bei haemorrhagischen Diathesen [Leipzig] 20p. 8? Zeulenroda, 1931. Aubertin, C, & Lafon, J. Purpura avec incoagulabilite plasmatique. Sang, Par, 1940, 14: 249-53.—Becart, A. Syndromes hemorragiques; maladies dues k un trouble de 1'hemostase; etude clinique. Gaz. hop, 1933, 106: 875-8.— Carpenter, G, & Allen, J. G. A defect in clot formation ob- served in 3 cases of chronic agnogenic hemorrhagic disease. Am. J. M. Sc, 1941, 202: 655-62.—Ferguson, J. H. The role of blood clotting anomalies in the hemorrhagic diseases. J. Lab. Clin. M, 1940-41, 26: 52-64. ------& Erickson, B. N. Role of blood-clotting anomalies in the hemorrhagic diseases. Am. J. Dis. Child, 1941, 61: 880-2.—Held, I. W. The relation of thrombocytes to hemorrhagic diathesis. Arch. Int. M, 1926, 37: 414-30.—La Barre, J. Les hemorragies: leurs causes peuvent etre definies par une etude approfondie des troubles de la coagulabiUte sanguine. Strasbourg med, 1926, 85: 22-8.—McDowell, J. F. Idiopathic hypocalcemia with pur- pura; treatment with dihydrotachysterol. J. M. Ass. Ala- bama, 1941-42, 11: 128-30.—Quick, A. J. A clinical classi- fication of hemorrhagic diseases due to coagulation defects Wisconsin M. J, 1940, 39: 517-20. ---- Hemotrypsia [Chevallier, 1924] Broustet, P, Levy, J., & Vallat, J. Sur un cas d'hemogenie hemotrypsique. J. med. Bordeaux, 1939, 116: 553-6.—Weil, P. E. Quelques remarques sur l'hemotrypsie. Bull. Soc med. hop. Paris, 1926, 3. ser, 50: 1667-9. ------ L'hemo- trypsie hemorragipare. Sang, Par, 1930, 4: 392-404. ------ Hemotrypsies anemiantes et hemoglobinuripares. Ibid, 405-12. ——— Le traitement des hemorragies hemotryp- siques chez la femme. Monde med, 1931, 41: 573-83. Les hemorragies hemotrypsiques chez la femme. In Livres jubiL (Roger, G. H.) Par, 1932, 231-7. ---- Henoch-Schonlein type. See also subheadings Allergic type; Vascular type; also in 3. ser. under Purpura. Brenxscheidt, R. *Beitrag zur Kenntnis der Henoch'schen Purpura beim Erwachsenen 18p. 8? Berl., 1933. Acerbi, L. Su un caso di porpora tipo Schoenlein-Henoch in un lattante. Med. ital, 1939, 20: 503-7.—Adant. M„ * Verly, R. Purpura abdominal de Henoch et troubles de la glycoregulation. Rev. beige sc. med, 1935, 7: 630-9. - Alessandri, C. Brevi considerazioni intorno ad un caso di M, di Schonlein Henoch in corso di cura pneumotoracica. Riv. chn. med, 1929, 30: 259-07. Barath. I. [Semeiology of abdominal purpura; 6 cases] Orv. hetil, 1934, 78: 967.— Bascape, A. Considerazioni su di un caso di porpora addomi- nale. BoU. Soc. med. chir, Pavia, 1935, 19: 121-6.—Bateman, D. Two cases of anaphylactoid, Henoeh-Schonlein, purpura Proc. R. Soc. M, Lond, 1938-39, 32: Sect. Stud. Dis. Child, 327-9.—Bazan, F. Sobre un caso de purpura abdominal. Arch, argent, pediat., 1935. 6: 154-60. Also Prensa med. argent, 1935,22:14-1 1-8.—Bloch, O.E. Purpura mesenterica (?) Louisville Month. J. M. & S, 1914-15, 21: 8-10.—Bojesen, A. [Demonstration of a case of purpura abdominalis (Henoch) and infantile tetany] Ugeskr. laeger, 1917, 79: 1394.—Brad- shaw, R. W. Henoch's purpura, with report of a case. Ohio M. J, 1927, 23: 754.—Brangwin, C. H, & Burr, G. P. Henoch's purpura. China M. J, 1928, 42: 376-8.—Brogi, G. Sulla etiopatogenesi del morbo di Schonlein-Henoch; osservazione clinico-sperimentale. Clin, pediat. Mod, 1940, 22: 34-47.— Callerio, G. Contributo cUnico alia conoscenza del morbo di Schoenlein-Henoch. Riv. clin. med, 1928, 29: 399-414.— Carbonara, G. Su di un grave caso di malattia da siero con porpora di Henoch-Schoenlein: considerazioni sulla patogenesi delle malattie da siero. Pediat. prat. Mod, 1928, 5: 266-75.— Casaubon, A, & de Filippi, F. A prop6sito de un caso de purpura de Schonlein-Henoch. Sem. mid, B. Air, 1928, 35: pt 2, 1405-9.—Case (A) of Henoch's purpura. Guy's Hosp. Gaz, Lond, 1928, 42: 249.—Clark, J. S. Purpura hemorrhagi.-a of the Schonlein-Henoch type. IUinois M. J, 1933, 63: 13K- 41.—Collina, G. Purpura abdominalis di Henoch senza manifestazioni petecchiali. Gior. med. prat, 1936, 18: 319- 27.—Copello, F. Vitamina C e porpora addominale di Schoen- lein-Henoch. Riv. clin. pediat, 1939, 37: 587-612.—Dassen, R, & Gitlin, S. PQrpura anafilactoidea (ptirpura abdominal de Henoch) Sem. med, B. Air, 1936, 43: 1137-42.—Day, L. A case of Henoch's purpura. Brit. M. J, 1909, 2: 1405.— Dinkier, G. KUnische Verlaufsformen der Purpura rheumatica und Purpura abdominalis (athrombopenische Purpura, hamor- rhagische KapiUartoxikose E. Frank, Morbus Schonlein- Henoch) Deut. med. Wschr, 1938, 54: 523-7.—Fiorentini. A. La malattia di Schonlein-Henoch. Pediatria (Riv.) 1930, 38: 557-68.—Forni, G. Porpora addominale e porpora vescicale. Arch. ital. chir, 1940, 59: 312-25.—Gara, A. Adatok a Henoch-feie purpura abdominalis ismeretehez. Orv. hetil, 1912, 56: 471.—Gardner, E. D. A case of Henoch's purpura. Boston M. & S. J, 1917, 177: 118.—Gelli, G, & Malossi, C. Manifestazioni angioneurotiche e malattia di Schoenlein- Henoch. CUn. pediat. Mod, 1931, 13: 149-71.—Goldstein, E. Schonlein-Henoch's purpura; report of a case with review of the literature. Med. Clin. N. America, 1928, 12: 869-81 — Gonzalez-Bosch, R. Purpura de Schonlein-Henoch (toxicosis capilar hemorriigica) Sem. med, B. Air, 1928, 35: 1155-8.— Griggs, J. F. Henoch's purpura in relation to allergy. North- west M, 1931, 30: 91-4.—Howie, W. C. A case of Henoch's purpura. Australas. M. Gaz, 1908, 27: 669-70.—Kondo, R. Henoch's Purpura, case report; Jikwa Zasshi, 1917, June 20. China M. J, 1918. 32: 462.—Kriukov, A. N., & Agamalov, K. 1. [The problem of Henoch's syndrome in internal pathology] Ter. arkh, 1940, 18: 542-51— Liakhovsky, V. M. [Patho- genesis of Henoch's disease] Sovet. vrach. J, 1936, 1: 370-2.— MacGillivray, A. G. Henoch's purpura in an adult. Brit. M. J, 1927, 1: 279.—Macmillan, A. S. A case of Henoch's purpura, or purpura abdominalis. Ibid, 1910, 2: 1718 — Malaguzzi Valeri, O. Considerazioni sull'eziopatogenesi della malattia di Schoenlein Henoch. Arch. ital. pediat, 1939-40, 7: 174-211.—Moore, J. R. Henoch's purpura; report of a case. Southwest. M, 1922, 6: 390-3.—Moritz, D. [Purpura ab- dominalisj Orv. hetil, 1937, 81: meU, 151.—Parkinson, J. P. Three cases of Henoch's purpura. Proc. R. Soc. M, Lond, 1908-9, 2: Sect. Stud. Dis. Child, 184-90—Pashkina. N. 1. [Schonlein-Henoch's disease; diagnostic errors] Pediatria, Moskva, 1940, No. 11, 52-6.—Piney, A. A case of the Schon- Iein-Henoeh syndrome. Lancet, Lond, 1933, 2: 1144 — Pooler, H. W. Henoch's purpura in an adult. Brit. M. J, 1930, 2: 562.—Prieur, G. O., Fish, H., & Sprague, P. H. A case of Henoch's purpura. Canad. M. Ass. J, 1937, 37: 583-5.—Rehberg. Ueber Purpura abdominalis beim Erwach- senen. Zbl. inn. Med, 1926, 47: 498-501.—Ryang, W. T. An autopsy observation of a case with Henoch's purpura. J. Chosen M. Ass, 1937, 27: 33.—Sacchetti, A. Un caso di morbo di Schonlein-Henoch. Riforma med, 1938, 54: 1638- 41.—Salles, M. Purpura de Henoch-Schonlein; sua natureza allergica. Brasil med, 1934, 48: 228.—Schetelig, G. ICase reports on Schonlein-Henoch's disease] Fin. lak. sail, hand, 1934, 76: 264-74.—Scroggie, A., Gantes, R., & Wiederhold, A. Purpura de Schonlein-Henoch. Rev. chilena pediat, 1940, 11: y^1'—Se'dlmayer, H. Sippenforschungen bei Tragern von Schbnlein-Henochscher Erkrankung. Zschr. Kinderh, 1939, 61: 488-502.—Shinkareva, S. [CUnical aspect and etiology of Schoenlein-Henoch's disease] Pediatria, Moskva, 1938, No. 9, 103-7.—Smith, O. C. Two cases of Henoch's purpura; with remarks upon the gastrointestinal lesions. Med. Rec, N. Y., 1904, 66: 890-3. Also repr.—Smock, B. W. HEMORRHAGIC DIATHESIS 545 HEMORRHAGIC DIATHESIS Henoch's purpura. Kentucky M. J, 1940, 38: 10-8.—Smoliak, Z. S. [On the cUnical aspect of Henoch-Schonlein's disease] Radianska med, 1940, 5: No. 10, 69-71. --- Henoch-Schonlein type, acute [Purpura abdominalis] Faysse, J. *Contribution a l'etude du syn- drome abdominal aigu du purpura. 174p. 25cm. Lyon, 1938. Alperstein, B. B. Allergic purpura and acute abdominal symptoms. Med. Rec, N. Y, 1941, 154: 218-22.—Antonioli, G. M. Sindrome addominale acuta da porpora di Henoch. Riforma med, 1936, 52: 1508-11.—Armand-Delille, Mathey [et al.] Purpura abdominal simulant une peritonite algide par perforation appendiculaire chez un enfant de 3 ans. Bull. Soc. pediat. Paris, 1934, 32: 494-7.—Bailey, H. Purpura as an acute abdominal emergency. Brit. J. Surg, 1930, 18: 234-40.— Bernard, A. Les crises abdominales au cours du purpura rhumatoldo. J. sc. med. Lille, 1930, 48: 12; 31.—Botrel, Ory & Vichard. Purpura rhumatoide avec syndrome pseudo-appendi- culaire. Bull. Soc. med. mil. fr, 1938, 32: 127-9.—Canonne. Syndrome abdominal aigu avec apparition d'ulcere duodenal au cours d'un purpura rhumatoide. Bull. Soc. chir. Paris, 1933, 25: 659-68.—Fary, B. Peliosis rheumatica mit schweren gastro-intestinalen Erscheinungen. Pest. med. chir. Presse, 1900, 36: 793-7.—Ferrari, R. C. Sobre manifestaciones abdominales de la purpura. Bol. Soc cir. B. Aires, 1937, 21: 359-63. Also Bol. Inst. clin. quir, B. Air, 1937-38, 13: 205- 7.—Fraser, I. Purpura simulating the acute abdomen. Lancet, Lond, 1930, 2: 525.—Fulvio, R. Un caso al porpora primitiva con sindrome addominale di Henoch. Rass. pediat, 1911, 2: No. 8, pt 6.—Gray, T. Henoch's purpura causing acute obstruction twice in 8 days. Lancet, Lond, 1936, 1: 841.— Hadley, J. A. Henoch's purpura in an adult simulating acute abdomen. Brit. M. J, 1927, 1: 720.—Herman, J. B. Schon- lein-Henoch's purpura simulating the acute surgical abdomen, Connecticut M. J, 1940, 4: 202-7.—Kennedy, A. M. Some acute abdominal manifestations of purpura. Clin. J, Lond, 1928, 57: 337-40.—Lichty, J. A, & Donaldson, H. H. Report of 2 cases of Henoch's purpura with symptoms like acute appendicitis. Arch. Diagn, N. Y, 1909, 2: 289-92.—Marx, C, & Boulenger, P. Le syndrome abdominal du purpura. Gaz. med. France, 1934, 496-9.—Morenas & Delore, P. Purpura rhumatoide k eruption tardive prcced6e d'un syndrome abdominal simulant la perforation d'ulcus duodenal. Lyon med, 1926, 137: 140-2.—Nobecourt, P. Les accidents abdomi- naux au cours des purpuras. Med. inf., Par, 1910, 7: 97-106.— Notti, H. H. Sindrome abdominal agudo en un purpurico. Bol. Soc. cir. B. Aires, 1936, 20: 1151-7.—Popov, S. M. [Acute abdomen in purpura (Henoch's disease)] Khirurgia, Moskva, 1939, No. 10, 64-71.—Scheffelaar Klots, T. [Acute abdominal syndrome in purpura] Geneesk. gids, 1933, 11: 285, 321.— Seneque, J, & Gosset, J. Le syndrome abdominal aigu au cours du purpura. J. chir. Par, 1932, 40: 828-47.—Spillmann, P, & Hanns. Le syndrome abdominal du purpura rhumatoide. Province med. Par, 1910, 21: 293.—Sudakevich, A, & Solovey, M. [Purpura abdominalis simulating gastric ulcer] Russ. klin, 1930, 13: 304-10.—Szekacs, B, & Fary, B. [A case of ... with grave gastro-intestinal symptoms] Gyogyiiszat, 1900, 40:436.— Zampa, G. La sindrome pseudoperitonitica nella porpora di Schonlein-Henoch. Minerva med. Tor, 1934, 25: pt 2, 119-27 --- Henoch-Schonlein type: Complication. Kissileff, G. *Purpura rhumatoide et troubles gastro-intestinaux. 36p. 8? Montpel., 1905. Vielliard, I?. *Etude des crises douloureuses abdominales en rapport avec le purpura. 118p. 8? Par., 1907. Arthritic purpura; acute pulmonary edema; acute focal glomerular nephritis; splenomegaly; hepatomegaly; cardiac hypertrophy and dilatation; ascites. North Carolina M. J, 1942, 3: 97-9.— Ballin, M, & Morse, P. F. Intussusception complicating visceral (Henoch's) purpura. Ann. Surg, 1930, 91: 711-3.—Benedict, W. L. Schonlein-Henoch's purpura with intra-ocular hemorrhage and iritis. J. Am. M. Ass, 1930, 95: 1577-9.—Clark, J. S. Purpura haemorrhagica of the Schonlein- Henoch type, report of a case. Arch. Ophth, Chic, 1932, 8: 649-53. Also repr.—Don, A. Case of Henoch's purpura associated with angioneurotic oedema. Practitioner, Lond, 1908, 80: 823-8.—Ferrabouc, L, Guichene, P, & Simonin, J. Purpura, orchi-epididymite, arthrite staphylococcique, evolu- tion benigne. Bull. Soc. med. mil. fr, 1937, 31: 221-3.— Gamstedt, E. Invagination iliaque dans un cas de purpura de Henoch. Acta chir. scand, 1933, 73: 280-4.—Gougerot, H, & Thibaut. Purpura articulaire du bras gauche et zona du bras droit symetriques. Arch. mal. coeur, 1912, 5: 726-30.— Holubec, K. Chirurgische Komplikationen bei Purpura abdomi- nalis. Zbl. Chir, 1935, 62: 2962-6.—Lacombe. Un cas de purpura rhumatoide, nephrite consecutive. Rev. prat. mal. pays chauds, 1937, 17: 445-55.—Lett, H. Henoch's purpura and intussusception. Rep. Soc. Study Dis. Child, Lond, 1907-8, 8: 307-321. Also Med. Press & Circ, Lond, 1908, n. ser, 85: 475.—Love, J. W. Massive, spontaneous hemorrhages nto the vitreous humor, and iritis in both eyes, accompanying ™ »chonleiii-Henoch's syndrome. J. Missouri M. Ass, 193L 28: 59o-7.—Motolese, F. Papillite ottica bilaterale e strabismo convergente-alternante da porpora esantematica reumatoide Ann. ottalm, 1912, 41: 361-6.—Nove-Josserand, L, & Revol. 1 urpura rhumatoide grave avec hematuries persistantes chez un enfant Lyon med, 1936, 157: 70-2.— Philibert, A. Purpura rhumatoide et maladie de Quincke. Progr. med Par 1912 3. ser, 28: 214.—Rathery, F, & Derot, M. Etude clinique Diologique et anatomopathologique d'un cas de nephrite subaigue apparue apres un purpura rhumatoide. Bull. Soc med. hop. Paris, 1934, 3. ser, 50: 1430-6.—Siegl, J. Spastische Hemiparese im Verlaufe einer Schonlein-Henochschen Purpura Arch. Kinderh, 1937, 111: 111-3.—Sturtevant, M, & Graef, I. Henoch-Schonlein purpura with paralytic ileus and rheumatic i0ultlS; ed'rCIin- N' America. 1933, 17: 91-101.—Tonking, J. H. A case of Henoch's purpura with intussusception. Lan- cet, Lond 1910, 2: 802 TUrpkel, M. Ueber einen Fall von 1 urpura abdominalis Henoch, zugleich ein Beitrag zum Artikel von Walter Spitzer: Ein Fall von Appendicitis acuta, kombiniert mit 1 urpura haemorrhagica des Peritoneums. Zbl. Chir 1932 59: 462-5. ---- Henoch-Schonlein type: Etiology. Catalogne, A. J. *De l'origine digestive de certains purpuras; quelques cas de purpuras avec lesions intestinales. 32p. 24>2cm. Par., 1939. Alexander, H. L, & Eyermann, C. H. Food allergy in Henoch's purpura. Arch. Derm. Syph, Chic, 1927, 16: 322- ''•—Bradburn, T. S. Oral sepsis simulating Henoch's purpura. Brit. M. J, 1914, 1: 525.—Gabbi, G. Contributo statistico alletiologie tubercolare della porpora tipo Schoenlein-Henoch Gior. clin. med, 1933, 14: 1674-84.—Hampton, S. F. Henoch's purpura based on food allergy, a report of 2 cases. J. Allergy, 1940-41, 12: 579-91, pl.—Kahn, I. S. Henoch's purpura due to food allergy. J. Lab. Clin. M, 1928-29, 14: 835.—Wein- giirtner, L. Purpura Schonlein-Henoch als Folgeerscheinung einer Erstvakzination. Kinderarztl. Prax, 1941, 12: 39-41. ---- Henoch-Schonlein type, rheumatic [Pelio- sis rheumatica] Feuillastre, L. *L'allergie dans les purpuras rhumatoides (essai pathogenique et therapeuti- que) 87p. 8? Par., 1933. Simon, Y. *Purpura rhumatoide, maladie du serum et anaphylaxie. 55p. 8? Par., 1926. Wagner, D. K. *TJeber recidivierende Pur- pura Schonleini [Berlin] 14p. 21cm. Baruth, 1937. Abelmann, M. L. [Cases of ... in the earlier infantile age] Vrach, St Petersb, 1892, 13: 197.—Angelini, G. Peliosi reumatica (porpora di Schonlein-Henoch) ortostatica con poliglobulia. Riv. clin. med, 1934, 35: 349-61.—Banerjee, P. K. A case of purpura rheumatica (Schonlein's disease) Ind. M. Gaz, 1933, 68: 572.— Berggreen. Schonleinsche Purpura (zum Gedaehtnis an Johann Lukas Schonlein,) Zbl. Haut Geschlkr, 1939, 62: 340.— Bonduel, A. Purpura reuma- toide. Sem. med, B. Air, 1941, 48: 353.—Boucher, R. Pur- pura rhumatoide. Union med. Canada, 1932, 41: 19-22.— Cabodevilla, H. S. Purpura de Schonlein. Prensa med. argent, 1939, 26: pt 2, 2000-5.—Camart. Un cas de peiiose rhumatismale. Clinique, Brux, 1901, 15: 137-40.—Cantonnet, H. Purpura reumatoide flictenular. Arch, pediat. Uruguay, 1933, 4: 21.—Carnot, P, Libert, E, & Bariety, M. Purpura rhumatoide pretuberculeux. Bull. Soc. med. hop. Paris, 1926, 3. ser, 50: 695-9.—Castellino, P. Peliosi reumatica tipo Schonlein o porpora anafilattoide. Fol. med. Nap, 1934, 20: 1026-38.—Chevallier, P., & Moutier, F. Le purpura rhuma- toide purement ecchymotique (sous-cutane) Sang, Par, 1936, 10: 1022-7.—Church. A case of poliosis rheumatica, or ery- thema multiforme. S. Barth. Hosp. J, Lond, 1893-94, 1: 100.—Debre, R, Lamy, M, & Baudry, C. Purpura rhumatoide, maladie du serum et anaphvlaxic Paris med, 1926, 59: 566- 8.—Dubois-Havenith. Purpura rhumatoide. Policlinique, Brux, 1912,21:7.—Duquaire. Un cas de peiiose rhumatismale. Lyon med, 1901, 96: 600.—Fernando, C. F. A case of purpura rheumatica. J. Ceylon Brit. M. Ass, 1928, 25: 21.—Fox, G. H. Peliosis rheumatica. J. Cut. Dis. incl. Syph, 1904, 22: 585.— Francois-Dainville, E. Des etats hemorragiques dans la pretuberculose et de la nature tuberculeuse du purpura rhuma- toide. Clin. prat. m6d. chir. path. Par, 1909, 5: 201-5.— Frick, W. Purpura rheumatica. Kansas City M. Index, 1896, 17: 159.—Germain, A. Un cas de purpura rhumatoide post- grippal. Bull. Soc. med. hop. Paris, 1935, 3. ser, 51: 1736-8. ------ & Escartefigue. Purpura rhumatoide suivi de des- quamation scarlatiniforme. Bull. Soc. fr. derm, syph, 1936, 43: 1051-3.—Goedhart, C. [Case of purpura rheumatica ending in death] Ned. tschr. geneesk, 1928, 72: pt 2, 3876- 80.— Haga, W. [Observations on rheumatic purpura] Tokvo med. Wschr, 1892, No. 761, 1-4.—Harris, W. [Peliosis rheumatica: Schonlein's disease] Clin. J, Lond, 1908, 32: 328.—Kruzenstern. Sluchai peliosis rheumaticae gravis. Vrach, St Petersb, 1895, 16: 757-61.—La Torre, H. de, & Guerra Rousseau, R. A propos to de una purpura de Schonlein. 227475—VOL. 7, 4th sbaies- -35 HEMORRHAGIC DIATHESIS 540 HEMORRHAGIC DIATHESIS Rev. med. cubana, 1935, 46: 26-31.—Lim.:, C. R. Un caso dc purpura periarticular 6 peliosis reumatoide; curaci6n. Med. nifios, 1909, 10: NJ-9L— Long, J. IV, jr, & Orr. R. A. Purpura rheumatica complicating the pucrperium. Am. J. Obst, 1010, 39: 13S -40.- .Mackenzie, S. On the relationship of purpura rheumatica to erythema exudativum multiforme. Brit. J. Derm, 1896, 8: 116-29.—Martinez Vargas. Purpura peri- articular y nn peliosis reunuitica. Med. nifios, 1922, 23: 353- 65.— .\lavcr, M. Peliosis rheumatica und Trauma. Aerztl. Sachverst. Ztg, 1900, 6: 256.—Miqurl, B. Purpura prepuber (peliosis reumatica) nefritis hcmorrdgica;hemocultivo;curaci6n. Med. nifios, 1913, 14: 247-51.—Paisseau, G, & Vialard. S. Purpura rhumatoide; presence de bacilles acido-resistants pre- sentant les caracteres de 1'ultra-virus tuberculeux. Bull. Soc. med. hop. Paris, 1927, 3. ser, 51: 1461-6.—Pelnar [Purpura rheumatica] Cesk. derm, 1922, 3: 77.—Richet, C, fils, & Dublineau, J. Le purpura rhumatoide de nature anaphylac- tique. J. med. fr, 1930, 19: 182-4.—Roubier, C. Un cas de peiiose rhumatismale, ipoussees successives, apparu k la suite d'une castration, avec examen hematologique. Bull. Soc. m6d. hop. Lyon, 1908, 7: 277-80.—Schupfer, F. Sopra un caso di malattia di Schonlein. Minerva med.. Tor, 1934, 25: 241-50.—Sezary, Horowitz & Rivoire. Purpura rhumatoide anaplo, lactique k poussees subintrantes provoquees par l'effort musculaire. Bull. Soc. m6d. hop. Paris, 1931, 3. ser, 47: 760- 8.—Shaw, F. W. A case of peliosis rheumatica. J. Kansas M. Soc . 1909, 9: 303.—Silvestrini, R. Quadro clinico di porpora reum&tica con reperto di streptococco. Policlinico, 1933, 40: sez. prat, 1123-8.—Smirnov, S. [Two cases of rheumatic purpura] Sibirsk. vrach. gaz, 1912, 5: 265-70.—Tompkins, J. M. Purpura rheumatica. Old Dominion J. M. & S, 1915, 20: 21H.—Valvassori-Peroni, C. La peliosi reumatica; note di patogenesi; caso clinico di peliosi reumatica, nefrite tossica ed indicanuria. Pediatria, Nap, 1898, 6: 176-85. ---- Henoch-Schonlein type: Treatment. Aubertin, ('.., Levy, R, & Lereboullet, J. Action do 1'irra- diation spioniquc dans un cas de purpura rhumatoide. Bull. Soc. med. hop. Paris, 1928, 3. ser, 52: 1071-4.—C'habnl. Purpura rhumatoide avec hemorragies intestinales, traitee s par des injections de serum antidiphterique. Bull. Soc. med. Vaucluse, Avignon, 1910, 6: 345-8.—Cook, J. B. A case of Henoch's purpura; laparotomy; pneumonia; death. Lancet, Lond, 1909, 2: 1587. Dargein & Dore, G. R. Purpura rhumatoide avec ent6rorragies profuses recidivantes traite par le s6rurri antidiphterique et l'anth6ma. Bull. Soc. m6d. hop. Pari-., 1926, 3. ser, 50: 1346-9.—Hoet, J. P., & Vyve. A.vin [Prothrombin content during the course of Henoch-Sclionlein s purpura and treatment with methyl derivatives of naphtho- quinone] Ned. tschr. geneesk, 1940, 81: 1777-9. Also Acta brevia neerl, 1940, 10: 122-5.—Jeriild, T. Therapeutic effect of vitamin P in Schonlein-Henoch purpura. Lancet, Lond, 1938, 1: 1445-7. I.onbcrg, A. [Trials of ascorbic acid in the treatment of Schonlein-Henoch's purpura] Ugeskr. laeger, 1930, 98: 1967-71.—Myers. B, Cordon, A. K, & Maingot, R. Investigation of a case of Henoch's purpura treated by splen- ectomy. Brit. J. Child. Dis, 1920, 2.1: 241-54, pl—Seifert, E. Die chirurgische Seite der Purpura abdominalis (Henoch) Beitr. klin. Chir, 1931-32, 154: 575-84.—Zheltov, L. I. [Treat- ment of Schonlein-Henoch's disease] J. profil. subtrop. klin. med, Tashkent, 1934, 4: 74-6. ---- Hepatic type. See also Chloroform, Poisoning; Jaundice; Liver, Cirrhosis; Phosphorus, Poisoning, &c. Abrami, P. Le purpura des hepatiques. Ann. med. Par, 1935,37:71-9. ------Bertrand-Fontaine [et al.] De l'origine spienique du purpura des hepatiques. Paris m6d, 1932, 83: 446-9.—Abrami, P, & Fouquet, F. Origine spl6nique du purpura des hepatiques. Nutrition, Par, 1934, 3: 631-45.— Chevallier, P. La nature inflammatoire du purpura de> cinho- liques. Sang, Par, 1940, 14: 253-7.—Gernich, R, Palazon, J. M, & Lellis, J. D. M. de. Purpura cronica v litiasis biliar Prensa med. argent, 1936, 23: 2390-3.—Gonzalez Guzman, I. Iiisuricienciu hepdtica y septicemia como factores patogenicos dc las purpuras. Rev. mex. biol, 1930, 10: 13.—Kugelmass, I. N. Vitamin K in pseudohemophiUa hepatica of childhood. Internat. CUn, 1939, n. ser. (2) 4: 84-7.—Stone, M. L, & Bunim, J. J. Cutaneous hemorrhage during puerperium with later development of acute yellow atrophv. Am. J Obst 1936, 31: 1015-9.—Willebrand, E. A. [Hepatogenous hemor- rhagic diathesis] Fin. lak. siiU. hand, 1933, 75: 829-46. ---- hereditary. See also Angiomatosis, heredofamilial: Rendu- Osler-Weber-Goldstein type; Epistaxis; Hemo- philia; Purpura annularis teleangiectodes, &c. Bronisch, F. W. *Erbliche haemorrhagische Diathese bei eineiigen Zwillingen [Berlin] 14n 8? Hamb., 1937. Aschner, B. Zur KrU.iologie der Blutkrankheiten; die hamorrhagischen Diathesen. Z.-chr. klin. Med., 1934 127- 415-33.—Bailey, F. R, A: McAlpin, K. R. Familial purpura- report of 2 cases. Am. J. M. Sc, 1935, 190: 263-8.— Bruun, E. Hereditary hemorrhagic diathesis. Acta med. scand, 1939, 102: 639- IS. Farber, J. L. A familial hemorrhagic condition simulating hemophilia and purpura hemorrhagica. Am. J. M. Sc, 19.il, 188: 81") 22. -Mercililnrv haemorrhagic disorders Brit. M. J, 1935, 2: 587. Minot. G. R. A familial hemor- rhagic condition associated with prolongation of the bleeding time. Am. J. M. Sc, 1928, 175: 301-6. Also Med. Press & Circ, Lond, 1928, n. ser, 126: 56-9.- -Rolling. E. Ueber liereditare hamorrhagische Diathesen. Acta med. scand, 1929 72: 101-12.—Weeks, E. Familial bleeding; report of 2 cases Am. .1. Dis. Child, 1934, 17: 131S-22. -Wintrobc. M. M. Familial and hereditary purpura. In Cyclop. Med. (Piers,|. Bortz) Phila, 1939, 2: 821.—Witts, I, J. The hereditary haemorrhagic diathesis. Guy's Hosp. Hep, Lond, 1932, 82: 465-74. ---- infantile and juvenile. See also subheading Prothrombin deficiency, &c. Araya Chiappa, P. *Los sindromas pur- piiricos en la infancia. 159p. 8? Santiago, 1929. Wetzel, S. Contribution a l'etude des purpuras de l'enfance. 102p. 8? Par., 1938. Abt, T. A. The purpuric diseases of childhood. Atlantic M. J, 1926-27, 30: 129-31.—Artamonov, A. [Purpura, according to observations in tin: Children's Hospital of St Olga] Pediatria, Moskva, 1913, 5: 100; 207; 264.—Baar, H. Zur Kenntnis der Blutungsiibel im Kindesalter. Wien. klin. Wschr, 1934, 47: 1039-43.—Berth L. Le diatesi emorragiche nell'infanzia. Pediat. med. prat. Tor, 1934, 9: 552-4.—Boyd, J. M, & Elliot, J. A. Idiopathic haemorrhage in the newborn. Brit. M. J, f930, 2: 213.—Capon, N. B. Purpura in childhood. Med. Press & Circ, Lond, 1938, 196: 423-6.—Dordi, A. M. Alcuni casi di malattia emorragica nell'infanzia. Pediat. med prat. Tor, 1939, 14: 79-98.—Fernandez, R, & Huaman, N. Contribucion al estudio de las diatesis hemorragicas en el lactante. Med. ibera, 1934, 29: pt 2, 59.—Frontali, G. Die hamorrhagischen Diathesen beim Kinde. Internat. med. W. Schweiz (1936) 1937, 2. Congr, 338-57 [Discussion] 457. Also Schweiz. med. Wschr, 1936, 66: 905-11.—Gallo, C. Considerazioni cUniche sulle porpore nell'infanzia. Pediatria (Riv.) 1926,34:404-14.—Groves, A. On essentialhsemorrhages; the cause and treatment of the essential haemorrhages of infants and of other so-called functional hsemorrhages. Med. Rev. of Rev, 1928, 34: 477-80.—Hess, J. H. Purpuras in children. Med. Clin. N. America, 1930-31, 14: 1073-81 — Higgins, J. M. Purpura in a boy 9 months old. Pennsylvania M. J, 1928-29, 32: 645.—Hoevelmann, E. Aetiologie und Therapie juvcniler Blutungen. Deut. med, Wschr, 1932, 58: 1996-8.—Hutinel. Quelques considerations sur le purpura. Pediat. prat, Lille, 1910, 8: 565-9.—Knauer, H. Mlutungen im Sauglingsalter. Zschr. arztl. Fortbild, 1934, 31: 485-8.— Konstantinov, V. P. [Hemorrhagic diathesis in children] Omsky med. J, 1929, 4: 57-63.—Kugelmass, I. N. The diagnosis of hemorrhagic diseases in infancy and childhood. Internat. Clin, 1930, 40. ser, 3: 180-3. ------ The mechanisn and management of hemorrhagic disturbances in infancy and in childhood. N. York State J. M, 1933, 33: 434-47.----- Hemorrhagic diseases in infancy and childhood. J. Med. Pract, 1936, 1: 7-11. ------ The nature of hemorrhagic diseases in children. Med. Rev. of Rev, 1936, 42: 269-71.— Macera, J. M. Purpura en un lactante, scguido de formacion rle escaias. Sem. med, B. Air, 1926. 33: 301; 893.—Medda, E. Le sindromi emorragiche nei bambino; forme clinichc Riv. clin. pediat, 1929, 27: 655-73.—Miranda Rodriguez, F. de. Hemorragias del reci6n nacido. Bol. Col. med. Cimaguey, 1941-42, 4: 153-60.—Moreira, R. La diatesi emorragica nell'infanzia. Rinasc. med, 1932, 9: 460-3.—Palmer, F. W. M. The haemorrhagic diathesis in a child of 12 simulating chronic gastric ulcer. Guy's Hosp. Rep, Lond, 1928, 78: 473.— Passalacqua, N. Diatesi emorragiche e metrorragie del periodo puberale. Monit. ostet. gin, 1938, 10: 771-811.—Poncher, H. G. Purpura as a symptom in pediatric practice. J. Am. M. Ass, 1935, 104: 1690-5.—Pounders, C. M. Purpura in children. South. M. J, 1936, 29: 317-23.—Runge, H. Novos resultados no diagnostico e terapeutica das hemorragias juvenis. Hora med, Rio, 1941, No. 42, 105; passim.—Schmidt, M. B, Fanconi [et al.] Ueber die Anamien und hamorrhagischen Diathesen im Kindesalter. Klin. Wschr, 1930. 15: 1377.— Schweizer, F, Cello, R. J, & Senet, O. H. Diatesis hemor- ragicas en la primera infancia. Arch, argent, pediat, 1934, 5: 72o-33.—Simko. I. [Hemorrhagic diseases in children] Budapesti orv. ujs, 1931, 29: 737; 761.—Sirca, A. Contributo alio studio della etio-patogenesi delle porpore secondarie nell'infanzia. CUn. pediat, Mod, 1927, 9: 467-82.—Viladesau, R. Purpuras en la infancia. Arch, ginecopatla, Barcel, 1915, 28: 148-55.—Witkin, M. Primary purpura in childhood. S. Afr. M. J, 1933, 7: 3-8— Wyllie, W. G, & Ellis, R. W. B. The clinical interpretation of some haemorrhagic states. Arch. Dis. Childh, Lond, 1931, 6: 313-24. ---- Infection. See also subheadings Allergic type; Purpura fulminans, &c; also names of infectious diseases. HEMORRHAGIC DIATHESIS 54 Desjeux, H. Contribution a l'etude du purpura staphylococcique. 70p. 8? Par., 193G. Spitzer, J. M. *Untersuchungen iiber ein Pneumokokkengift, welches bei der weissen Maus Purpura erzeugt. 23p. 20^cm. Bonn, 1938. Agostoni, A. Contributo alio studio delle porpore tuberco- lari. Gior. venet. sc. med, 1939, 13: 113-24.—Antonio, G. Sulla infezione emorragica. Atti Accad. Lincei, 1880-81, 3. ser, 5: 128-31.—Baar, H, & Gasul, B. M. Purpuric exan- thems in infectious diseases. Am. J. Dis. Child, 1929, 37: 126-33.—Barberi, S. Sui rapporti tra diatesi emorragica e infezione tubercolare. Arch. ital. pediat, 1932, 1: 182-96, 3 ch.—Bazan, F, & Ceroni, R. Accidentes cerebralos (hemi- plejia) en el curso de un purpura infeccioso. Arch, argent. pediat, 1936, 7: 813-30— Benhamou, E, & Odry. Purpura palustre. Bull. Soc. path, exot. Par, 1933, 26: 420-2.— Bernasconi, V. E. El sfutoma p&rpura como complicacion paliidica. Bol. Inst. clin. quir, B. -\ir, 1928, 4: 244-7.— Casaubon, A. Purpura y granulia. Dia med, B. Air, 1935, 7: 1449-51.—Cathala, J., Auzepy, P., & Brault, A. Purpura infectieux, septicemie meningococcique; evolution presque apyretique. Bull. Soc. med. hop. Paris, 1938, 3. ser, 54: 85-8.—Ciantini, F. Considerazioni su un caso di sepsi pur- purea e meningite da meningococco a decorso asintomatico. Terapia, Milano, 1937, 27: 193-7.—De Blasio, R, & Scrocca, P. Porpore e tubercolosi. Rass. internaz. clin. ter, 1935, 16: 1226-34, 2 pl.—De Luca, F. Contributo alio studio dei rap- porti fra diatesi emorragica e infezione tubercolare. Prat. pediat, Milano, 1933, 11: 366-74.—Goodner, K, & Horsfall, F. L, jr. The purpuric reaction produced in animals by derivatives of the Pneumococcus. Proc. Soc. Exp. Biol, N. Y, 1937-38, 37: 178-80.—Greengard, J. Purpuric mani- festations in tuberculosis. Am. Rev. Tuberc, 1931, 24: 452-78.—Julianelle, L. A, & Reimann, H. A. The production of purpura by derivatives of Pneumococcus, general considera- tions of the reaction. J. Exp. M, 1926, 43: 87-95.------ Further studies on the nature of the purpura-producing principle. Ibid, 1927, 45: 609-18.—Kwiatkowski [Purpura postgriposa] Przegl. derm, Warsz, 1935, 30: 162.—Lorando, N, Chaniotis, N, &• Choreftis, P. Purpura et paludisme. Bull. Soc. path, exot. Par, 1938, 31: 290-4.—Lunedei, A, & Giannoni, A. Studi sulle sindromi emorragiche, la patogenesi delle sindromi emorragiche del tifo e delle brucellosi. Riv. clin. med, 1936, 37: 241-86.—Maccari, F. Porpore e tubercu- lide Gior. ital. derm, sif, 1928, 69: 885. ------ La tuberco- losi come fattore predisponente di alcune forme di porpora (contributo casistico-istologico) Arch. ital. derm, sif, 1929-30, 357-68.—Magni, L. Sindrome surrenale acuta del tipo della porpora infettiva in una Irambina di tre anni e mezzo. Lattante, 1936, 7: 159-64, 3 pl.—Marotte. Meningococcemie et pur- pura. Bull. Soc. med. hop. Paris, 1924, 3. ser, 48: 594-7 — McLean, S. Endemic purpuric meningococcus bacteremia in early life, the diagnostic value of smears from the purpuric lesions. N. York State J. M, 1931, 31: 684. ------& Caffey, J. Endemic purpuric meningococcus bacteremia in early life, the diagnostic value of smears from the purpuric lesions. Am. J. Dis. Child, 1931, 42: 1053-74.—Martinez Garcia, P. Relacion entre el sindrome plirpura y la tuberculosis. Rev. med, Rosario, 1932, 7: 318-31.—Mendilahrzu, J, & Abdala, J. R. Purpura infeccioso en un lactante. Arch. amer. med, B. Air, 1935, 11: 234-8.—Muench, H, & Oles, J. Beitrage zur Purpurafrage; Purpura bei Tuberkulose; Purpura bei Lues. Fortsch. Med, 1926, 44: 815-7.—Nobecourt, P. Syndrome abdominal douloureux et purpura infectieux chez une fille de 13 ans. Presse m6d, 1940, 48: 983.—Oumansky, V, & Pescarolo, W. Purpura et tuberculose. Ann. med. Par, 1936, 40: 306-10.—Palombelli, L. Porpora emorragica semplice da paratifo B in soggetto affetto da avitaminosi latente. Policlinico, 1934, 41: sez. prat, 1482-6.—Poisno, R, Ciaudo, P. [et al.] Purpura gangreneux meningococcemique associe k une m6ningite cerebro-spinalo, guerison par la sero- therapie, le 1162 F. et la vitamine A. Bull. Soc. med. hop. Paris, 1939, 3. ser, 55: 891 (i. Reimann, H. A, & Julianelle, L. A. The production of purpura by derivatives of Pneumo- coccus, the effect of pneumococcus extract on the blood plate- lets and corpuscles. J. Exp. M, 1926, 43: 97-106.—Rolleston, H. D, & Molony, J. B. Purpura in infective diarrhoea. Proc. R. Soc. M, Lond, 1911-12, 5: Sect. Stud. Dis. Child, 54-9.— Sannicandro, G. Purpura auafilattoide di origine tubercolare. Dermosifiligrafo, 1930, 5: 570-84.—Seidlmayer, H. Die friiliinfantile, postinfektiose Kokarden-Purpura. Zschr. Kin- derh, 1939, 61: 217-55.—Soini, A. [Is ameba the cause of purpura?] Duodecim, Helsinki, 1939, 55: 923-5.—Stuhler, L. G. Purpura of infectious origin, report of a case. Proc. Mayo Clin, 1929, 4: 334.—Trabaud. Le purpura-palustre. Rev. med. Par, 1929, 48: 847-50.—Villa, L. Orientamenti per lo studio delle porpore secondarie tubercolari. Riv. pat. clin. tuberc, 1928, 2: 241-63, pl.—Vitamin K in an infectious hemorrhagic disease. South. M. J, 1941, 34: 1290.—Wolff & Brusset. Purpura infectieux k forme bulleuse. Bull. Soc. fr. derm, syph, 1928, 35: 977-81.—Wolf, & Levy, G. Purpura ecchymotique 2 ans apr£s une septicemie k streptocoque hemolytiques. Ibid, 1927, 34: 813-5.—Wright, H. P, & Bacal, H. L. Allergic tuberculous purpura. Am. J. Dis. Child, 1937, 53: 1276-81. HEMORRHAGIC DIATHESIS ---- Infection, acute. Berti, G. Contributo alio studio delle sindromi emorragiche mfettive acute. Clin, pediat. Mod, 1937, 19: 525-38 — Lusson & Sans. Purpura exanthematique. Rev. med, ^T1^16' J,90,' 143-6.—Ernst, A. Eine Purpuraepidemie. Med Khn, Berl, 1912, 8: 1272.— Launay, C. Les purpuras infectieux aigus primitifs. J. med. chir. Par, 1932 103- G24.—Raybaud, A, & Scarpellini, L. Role de quelques ex- traits glandulaires dans le determinisme des phenomenes hemorragiques au coins de certaines infections aigues. C. rend. Soc biol, 1933, 113: 104.—Sarrouy, C. Les purpuras infectieux au cours des maladies eruptives (rougeole) Arch. med. enf, 1934, 37: 456 62.—Wood-Smith, F. G. Purpura as a complication of scarlet fever. Brit. J. Child. Dis. 1931 28- 273-81. ---- Inflammatory form. Carpentier, H. J. *Un cas de purpura aigu inflammatoire a evolution benigne et a topo- graphie particuliere. 24p. 23>2cm. Par., 1939. Dhery, P. *Les purpuras petechiaux, in- flammatoires chroniques idiopathiques. 95p. 24cm. Par., 1939. Chevallier, P. [Inflammatory, primary, benign, chronic purpura] Vrach. delo, 1936, 19: 671-80. Also In Libro de oro M. R. Castex, B. Air, 1938, 2: 254-62. Also Bruxelles med, 1938-39, 19: 536-44.------L'ecchymatose aigue mouchetant un long trajet veineux. Sang, Par, 1938, 12: 789. ------ & Moutier, F. L'ecchymatose inflammatoire ou purpura inflammatoire ecchymotique. Ibid, 773-5. —;---- L'ecchymatose inflammatoire chronique simple. Ibid, 775-89. ------ Une epidemic (?) do purpura ecchy- motique inflammatoire, ecchymatose inflammatoire chronique. Ibid, 791-4.—Dusan, J, & Lombard, R. Dermite purpurique pigmentaire bilaterale consecutive k une phiebite post-grippale chez un heredo-syphilitique. Marseille med, 1937, 74: 466-8.— Harviar, P, Chevallier, P. [et al.] Un cas de purpura inflam- matoire chronique idiopathique. Sang, Par, 1935, 9: 305-14. ---- Manifestation. Brasi, M. Sul signiflcato e sulla patogenesi del segno di Grocco- Frugoni-Rumpel- Leede. Morgagni, 1929, 71: 2181- 208.—Cruz Coke, E. Sindromas hemorragicos. Rev. med. aliment, Santiago, 1935 37, 2: 3-9.—Doyne, P. G. Retinal changes in a case of purpura. Proc. R. Soc. M, Lond, 1930-37, 30: 946.—Goldstein, H. I. Hemorrhagic blood dyscrasias, symptomatology, diagnosis and treatment. J. M. Soc. N. Jersey, 1935, 32: 69-77. Also repr.— Nunes Ribeiro, G, jr. Sindromes hemorragicas. Rev. med. mil, Rio, 1940, 29: 3-19.—Recio, A. Sindromes hemorragicos. Cr6n. med. quir. Habana, 1927, 53: 169-82.—Veratti, G. Contributo alio studio della sindrome emorragica di Apitz. Boll. Soc. med. chir, Pavia, 1936, 50: 1151-0.—Vieillard. Paroxysmes dou- loureux dans le purpura de l'enfant. Gaz. mal. infant. Par, 1908, 10: 110. ---- Manifestation, gastro-intestinal and vis- ceral. See also under names of organs as Bladder, Purpura, &c. Bandow [F.] TJ. *Die Milbeteiligung der Mundhohle an den haemorrhagischen Diathesen mit zwei eigenen Fallen. 44p. 8? Heidelb., 1930. Baronnet, J. Contribution a l'etude des complications digestives du purpura: Invagina- tion intestinale [Paris] 35p. 24cm. Niort, 1938. Clotteau, E. V. *Le purpura gastrique solitaire; purpura chronique exclusivement sto- macal. 62p. 8? Par., 1937. Fischer, T. *D<\s syndromes abdominaux au cours du purpura chez l'adulte [Lyon] 59p. 8? Trevoux, 1935. Letorey, F. *Formes cliniques des complica- tions abdominales du purpura. 119p. 25cm. Lyon, 1938. Ascoli, M. Sulla porpora vescicale (studio di un caso clinico) Bull. Accad. med. Roma, 1928, 54: 8 12.—Beranger, R. P, & Iturrioz, T. Purpura aislada del peritoneo en una nifia de 4 anos de edad. Arch, argent, pediat, 1933, 4: 815-20.— Blum, V. Ueber Purpura vesicae und deren Folgezustiinde (Ulcus simplex vesicae pepticum) Verh. Deut. Ges. Urol. (1913) 1914, 4: 312-21.------Erwiderung auf A. Roth- schilds Bemerkungen zum Prioritatsstreit Blums gegen Prae- torius, betreffs der Purpura urologica. Zschr. Urol, 1925, 19: 157-9.—Chevallier, P., & Moutier, F. Le purpura chronique HEMORRHAGIC DIATHESIS 548 HEMORRHAGIC DIATHESIS isoie de l'estomac. Sansr Par.. 1936, 10: 396-S. -Dukes. C. E. Renal purpura. !'r. c. K. Soc. M, Lond, 1938-39, 32: Sect. Urol, 1322- Fity-MiiLih. T, jr. Digestive disturbances in the hemorrhagic disci*- -. J. M. Soc. N. Jersey, 1941, 38: 132-5.— Geisinger, J. F. Purpura of the urinary tract. Virginia M. Month, 1926-27, 53: 772-6.—Kuhlmann, J. Purpura isoie du peritoine. Presse med, 1933, 41: 441-3.—Montenegro, A. Purpura vesical. Rev. espec, B. Air, 1929. 4: ,~>92-L-- Rothschild, A. Bemerkungen zum Prioritatsstrcit Blums gegen Praetorius betreffs der Purpura urologica. Zschr. Urol, 1924, 18: 663-5.—Schindler, R. Chronic localized gastric purpura. Am. J. Digest. Dis, 1938-39, 5: 796-9.—Watson- Williams, E. The faucial lesions of purpura. J. Lar. Otol, Lond, 1938, 53: 181-7, pl. ---- Manifestation, neural. Cachik, Y. *Contribution a l'etude des complications hemorragiques cerebrales et menin- ges au cours des syndromes purpuriques. 34p. 24 cm. Par.. 1939. Andre-Thomas. A propos du proces-verbal; paralysie du sciatique poplite externe consecutive a une eruption purpurique; anesthesie diiiu.-.e des membres interieurs avec ar£flexie pilo- motrice. Rev. neur. Par, 1933, 40: 679-82.—Bousrez, A. Troubles nerveux abdominaux en rapport avecle purpura, leur cause commune: l'oedeme Clinique, Par, 1911, 6: 648.— Cabot, R. C. Purpura and convulsions. N. England J. M , 1933, 208: 382—1.—Dunlop, H. A. Purpura, with transient lesion of mid-brain. Proc. R. Soc. M, Lond, 1933, 26: Clin. Sect, 1353.—Grenet, H. Purpura et troubles sympathiques, Bull. Soc. pediat. Paris, 1939-40, 37: 154.—Lurie, /,. L. [Affec- tions of the nervous system in hemorrhagic diathesis] So\et. psikhonevr, 1940, 16: No. 2, 20 30.—Meyer, M. G. Purpura complicated by cerebral hemorrhage and gangrene of the lower extremities. J. Iowa M. Soc, 1935, 25: 491-3. -Miro- neaco, T, & Perlstein. Le purpura et les lesions des ganglions spiuaux. Bull. Soc med. hop. Paris, 1927, 3. ser, 51: 406-9. ---- Mixed type. Oathala, .1, & Ducas, P. Purpura chronique hereditaire; hemophile -In mogenie; spienectomie. Bull. Soc. med. hop. Paris, l'.i3.">, 3 ser, 51: 1694-703.—Dietrich, A, & Nordmann, M. V cruiche zur hamorrhagischen Diathese. Verh. Deut. path. Ges, 1930, 2a: 46 50.—Dyke, S. C. The clinical pathol- ogy of haemorrhagic states. Brit. M. J, 1937, 2: 092-4.— Jurgcns, R. Beitrag zur Pathologie und Klinik der Blutungs bereiltchaft. Zschr. klin. Med, 1933, 123: 649-86.—Lesne, E, Marquezy, R. A, & Stieffel, R. Purpura hemorragique chronique; hOniophilo-hemogenie, spienectomie, resultats. Bull. Soc. med. hop. Paris. 1928, 3. ser, 52: 1159-66.—Masi, C. Purpura abdominal, tipo npendicular en un hemofilico. Bol. Soc. cir, B. Air, 1935, 19: 65-72. Also Sem. med, B. Air, 1935, 42: 1415-8. Also Bol. Inst. clin. quir, B. Air, 1935-36, 11: 79-82.— Mas y Magro, F, jr. Hemophiloidc et purpura hemorragique thrombopenique. Sang, Par, 1937, 11: 916- 21.—Merklen, P, & Wolf, M. Dissociation therapeutique de rheiiiogene-hdmophilie. Bull. Soc. med. hop. Paris, 1925, 3. ser, 49: 1141-3.—Roskam, J. Sjndromes hemophilo- hemogeniqucs et syndromes hemogeniques par admiidstration de liquoide. Sang, Par, 1934, 8: 005-21.—Sevcrino, A. Su due casi di diatesi emorragica a tipo emonlo-hbrinopenico. Pediatria (Riv.) 1937, 45: 627-50.—Tschopp, W. Purpura mit hiimophilieartiger voriibergehender Gerinnungsstorung; Beitrag zur 1 rage der weiblichen Hiimophilie und der atypischen Blutungskrankheitcn. Zschr. klin. Med, 1937, 132: 293-307. ---- nutritional. See Cachexia; Deficiency disease; Nutrition, Disorder; Scurvy; Vitamin, Deficiency, &c. ---- Onyalai. Blackie, W. K. Onyalai: a review. Tr. R. Soc. Trop. M. II\g, Lond. 1937-38, 31: 207-26 —Gear, J. Onyalai, a form of purpura occurring in tropical Africa. S. Afr. M. J, 1938, 12: 032-7.—Joyeux, C. Onyalai. Presse med, 1938, 46: 257.— Massey, A. Y. Onyalai, a disease of Central Africa. J. Trop. M. Hyg, I...ml, 1907, 10: 116.—Morgan, A. A, & Squires, B. T. Onyalai in Northern Bechuanaland. S. Afr. M. J, 1940, 14: 231-3 — Onyalai; an African haemorrhagic disease. Med. J. Australia, 1939, 1: 903. ---- Pathogenesis. See also Blood coagulation, Mechanism. Heyei.mann, G. [F.] * Ueber das Wesen (Aetiologie, Pathogenese) und die moderne Svstematik der sogenannten hamorrhagischen Diathesen. 31p. 8? Bonn, 1931. Klein, S. J. *Ueber das Wesen der haemor- rhagischen Diathese und die Bedeutung ver- selni'dener Symptome in differential-diagnosti- scher Hinsicht. 62p. 22cm. Bonn, 1936. Kleu, W. * Ueber den gegenwartigen Si and der Lehre von den hartuorrhagi.sehen .Diathesen. -12p. 8? Bonn, 192(1. Korzel, H. *Zur Kenntnis der haemor- rhagischen Diathese. 36]). S? Bonn, 192S. Roskam, J., Weil, P. E. [et al.] Les purpuras, pathogenie. GOp. 27cm. Brux., 192G. Alcchinsky, A. Contribution k l'etude des phlnnmthies liemorragiques. Ann. Inst. Pasteur, Par, 1939, 63: -11-92.— Barinsttiii. L. A. Zur Pathogenese der Hamophilie und der Thron 1 openie. Arch. klin. Chir, 1927, 147: 7 19-64.— Iten i Inrans. E. Zur Krise in dor Problemlage der Purpura, Uaematolegica, Pavia, 1935, 16: 369; 401—Buinewitsrh. K. Leber Diathesis haemorrhagica. Zbl. inn. Med, 1934, 55: 609-18.—tain. A, it Barnaud. Le role du foie et do la rate dans la production des heinoiragies. Rev. crit. path. Par, 1932, 3: 387 90.- Chubrol, K. Les hematemeses dites essen- tielhs dans leurs relations avec la pathologic spli'no-hepatique. Bull. Soc. med. hop. Paris, 1932, 3. ser, 48: 655-9—Uecastello, A. Ueber hamorrhagische Diathesen. Wien. med. Wschr, 1930, 86: 286; 317; 376.—Frlich, M. Contribution k la patho- genie des etats hemorragiques. Tr. sc. Clin. inf. Univ. Varsovie, 1930, 71-3.— Fanano, V. Contributo alio studio dello diatesi emorragiche. Policlinico, 1928, 35: sez. med, 241-50.— Fanconi. Beitrage zur Lehre der haoniorilragischen Diathese. Schwebv mid. Wschr, 1928, 58: 112. -Fischer, I, & Fischer, T. Pathogenie du purpura et du d\ sfc.net ionnement gastro- intestinal qu'on reneontie an euuis de son evolution. Ibid, 1935, 65: 1209.-■ Gonzalez Guzman, I. Consideracinnes generales sobre las purpuras. Arch. lat. amer. card., Mex, 1930 31, 1: 208-13.—L'reil, A. Endoatiolugische Theorie der hamorrhagischen Diat la-sen. Verb. Deut. path, (les., 19311, 2,r>: 80-100.—Grillilh, W. 11, & Mill ford, 1). J. Choline, creatine and the labile methyl supply. Proc. Soc. Exp. Biol, N. Y, 1940, 45: 057.—Huet, G. J. Nicuwere beschouwingon over do purpura. Ned. mschr. verlosk, 1916, 5: 473-80.—Hynek, K. Le purpura experimental. Commun. Congr. derm. syph. fr, 1920, 3. Congr, 2: 11-5. Also P. verb. Congr. derm. syph. fr, 1926, 3. Congr, 07-71. ------& Prerovsky [Pathogenesis of purpura] Bratisl. lek. listy, 1925, 5: 50 00. ------ Con- tribution k la pathogenic des diatheses hemorragiques. Rapp. Congr. fr. med. (1925) 1926, 18. sess, 2: 471-80. Also Rev. med. est, 1926, 54: 223-31.—Kriimeke, F. Ueber den heutigen Stand der Frage der Purpuraerkrankungen. Miinch. med. Wschr, 1926, 78: 85(3-9.—Landau, A, & Hejman, W. [Clinical research on hemorrhagic diathesis] Polska gaz. lek, 1932, 11: 32.—Lobo, J. I. Patogenia e tratamento das doencas hemor- ragicas. Arq. biol, S. Paulo, 1940, 24: 253-60.—Lunedei, A. I fenomeni conseguenti alia stasi e all'ischemia provocate negli nrti nello studio delle sindromi emorragiche. Riv. clin. med, 1929, 30: 383; 423; 635.—Mills, C. A. Developments in our knowledge of the hemorrhagic diseases. Cincinnati J. M, 1926-27, 7: 9-15.—Mironescu, T, & Perlstein, A. [Zur Pathogenese der Purpura. Wien. klin. Wschr, 1927, 40: 843-5.—Nygaard, K. K. Newer knowledge of hemorrhagic diseases. Clin. Med, 1942, 49: 85.—Ritossa, P. Sull'etio- patogenesi delle diatesi emorragiche. Pediatria (Riv.) 1926, 34: 669-81.—Rosegger, H. Die hamorrhagischen Diathesen, Probleme ihrer Entstehung und Behandlung. Zbl. inn. vied, 1938, 59: 721; 753.—Roskam, J. Mecanisme de production de I'element purpurique et des hemorragies, pathogenie de I'incoercibilite des saignements. Rapp. Congr. derm. syph. fr, 1926, 3. Congr, pt 3, 1-19.— Schindler, R. Nervensystem und spontano Blutungen; mit besonderer Berucksichtigung der hysterischen Ecchymosen und der Systematik der hamor- rhagischen Diathesen. Abh. Neur. Psychiat, 1927, H. 42, 1-68.—Schoch, M. A. Neue Ergebnisse in Klinik und Patho- logie der Hautblutungen. Schweiz. med. Wschr, 1940, 70: 25, 49.—Thiers, H, & Boisson de Chazournes, L. Les causes d'erreur dans l'etude des purpuras experimentaux avec le lapin comme animal reactif; les lesions de la mise k mort par saignee carotidienne. C. rend. Soc. biol, 1937, 125: 679 — Tidy, H. L. Symptoms and pathogenesis of the haemorrhagic diathesis. Brit. M. J, 1930, 2: 107-39.—Udintsov, F. A. [Pathogenesis and clinical aspect of hemorrhagic diathesis] Radianska med, 1937, 2: No. 5, 151-9.—Weil, P. E. Les purpuras; clinique et mecanisme physiologique. Rapp. Congr. derm. syph. fr, 1926, 3. Congr, pt 3, 21-38. ------& Chalier, J. Purpura provoque par hypertension veincu-e. Bull. Soc. med. hop. Lyon, 1911, 10: 167-72.—Weil, P. E, Lespinne & Ferond. Les purpuras (pathogenie) Bruxelles med, 1925-26, 6: 1200-2. ---- Pathology. Bousrez, R. A. A. *De quelques localisations rares de l'ccdeme dans le purpura. 62p. 8! Nancy, 1909. Gatjthier, M. *Contribution a l'etude des nephrites apparues au cours du purpura. 131p. 8? Par., 1935. Benda, R, & Salembiez, H. A propos d'un epanchement pleural hemorragique survenu au cours d'une poussee aigue de purpura. Bull. Soc. med. hop. Paris, 1935, 3. ser, 51: 1200- 10.—Benvenuti, A. Sulle diatesi emorragiche: loro patologia e HEMORRHAGIC DIATHESIS 549 HEMORRHAGIC DIATHESIS terapia. Med. nuova, 1926, 17: 163; 183.—Fleischmann, I. [Otitis haemorrhagica and purpura] Orv. hetil, 1936, 80: 977 —Halstead, J. A. Purpura with a high diastolic blood pressure. N. England J. M, 1932, 206: 126-8.—Huber. F. A case of empyema in a subject suffering from purpura. Arch. Pediat, N. Y, 1908, 25: 838-40 — Kahlmeter, G. [A case of purpura resulting in scleroderma] Hyyea, Stockh, 1922, 84: 103—Lazarus, S. [C-vitamin balance in patients with hema- temesis and melena] Hospitalstidende, 1938, 81: 309-18.— Mas y Magro, F. Nosologia de las diatesis hemorrrAeicas. Siglo med, 1930, 85: 409-16.—Merklen & Wolf. La dis- sociation de la diathfise hemorragipare. Medecine, Par, 1925- 26 7-444 8.—Pape, R. Lungentriibung bei Purpura. Fortsch. Roentgenstrahl, 1933, 47: 49-57. Also Mitt. Ges. inn. Med. Wien, 1932, 31: 153.—Perlman, L, & Fox, T. A. Hemorrhagic diatheses; an analysis of 355 autopsy reports. ^ rch. Int. M, 1941 68: 112-20.—Pritchard, E. Specimens from case of purpura. Proc. R. Soc M, Lond, 1918-19, 12: Sect Stud. Dis. Child, 107.—Stetson, R. P., & Ferris, H. W. Hemo- chromatosis and purpura. Arch. Int. M, 1932, 50: 232.— Weber, F. P. Case of cutaneous haemosiderotic pigmentation from purpura in a woman with high blood-pressure. Brit. J. Derm. Syph, 1934, 46: 420-3.—Wigley, J. E. M, & Plummer, N S Purpura associated with bronchiectasis. Proc. R. Soc. M, Lond, 1936-37, 30: 23.—Zamfir, D, Paulian, V.,&Tomescu, I. Purpura et nephrite hypertensive; considerations anatomo- cliniques k propos d'un cas. Bull. Soc. med. hop. Bucarest, 1939, 21: 106-15. ---- Prognosis. Besdziek, I. *Die Schicksale der Werlhof- und Purpurakranken; untersucht an 40 Fallen der Breslauer Kinderklinik und an Fallen aus der Literatur [Breslau] 29p. 8? Hann. Miinden, 1935. Glanzmann, E. Prognose der hamorrhagischen Diathesen. Kinderarztl. Prax, 1933, 4: 418-24. ---- Prothrombin deficiency. See also Celiac disease; Dysentery; Intestine, Obstruction; Prothrombin; Vitamin K, &c. Bay, R. *Higado, protrombina, vitamina K; estudio experimental y clinico. 123p. 25}^cm. B. Air., 1940. Abbott, W. E, & Holden. W. D. Hvpoprothrombinemia in intestinal disorders. Am. J. Surg, 1941, 53: 215-8.—Allen, J. G, & Livingstone, H. Postoperative hypoprothrombinemia and anesthesia. Current Res. Anesth, 1941, 20: 298 — Allen, J. G, & Vermeulen, C. Destruction of prothrombin and storage of vitamin K. Arch. Surg, 1941, 42: 969-72.— Ansbacher, S. A new tvpe of vitamin K-deficient diets. Proc. Soc Exp. Biol, N. Y, 1940, 44: 248-50. ------ Additional observations on vitamin K-deficient diets. Ibid, 1941, 46: 421-4.—Bollman, J. L, Butt, H. R, & Snell, A. M. The influence of the liver on the utilization of vitamin K. J. Am. M. Ass, 1940, 115: 1087-91.—Brinkhous, K. M. Plasma prothrombin; vitamin K. Medicine, Bait, 1940, 19: 329-416. Also repr.—Butt, H. R. The preoperative and postoperative use of vitamin K in cases of deficiency of prothrombin. Surg. Clin. N. America, 1940, 20: 1203-10.—Cheney, G. The plasma coagulation time as a simple test for vitamin K deficiency. Am. J. M. Sc, 1940, 200: 327-37.—Cifuentes T, H. Funci6n hep&tica y vitamina K. Rev. chilena hig, 1941, 4: 3-30.— Dam, H, & Glavind, J. [Vitamin K in pathology of man] Ugeskr. laeger, 1938, 100: 248-50.—Fanconi, G. Blutungsubel des Kindesalters, die auf einer Stoning des Gerinnungsvor- ganges beruhen, unter besonderer Berucksichtigung des K- Vitamins. Schweiz. med. Wschr, 1941, 71: 185-7.—Fox, F. W. Vitamin K; notes on a newly-discovered dietary factor that regulates the clotting time of the blood. S. Afr. M. J, 1941, 15: 113-5.—Glynn, M. J. Bleeding due to prothrombin deficiency during gastrointestinal intoxication. Am. J. Dis. Child, 1941, 62: 1113.—Hult, H. [On K-avitaminosis] Nord. med, 1939, 4: 3627.—Jorpes, E. [Vitamin K and prothrombin formation] Ibid, 1940, 6: 933-6.—Kark, R, & Lozner, EL. Nutritional deficiency of vitamin K in man; a study of 4 non-jaundiced patients with dietary deficiency. Lancet, Lond, 1939, 2: 1162-4.—Kark, R, & Souter, A. W. Hypo- prothrombinaemia and avitaminosis-K in man. Brit. M. J, 1941 2: 190-4.—Mackie, T. T. Vitamin K deficiency in the absence of jaundice. N. York State J. M, 1940, 40: 987-95.— Mason, H. C. Normal and abnormal prothrombin levels. Proc. Soc. Exp. Biol, N. Y, 1940, 44: 70-3—Mazzini, 0.i.,& Meyer, G. B. Vitamin K y cirugia; modificaciones de la pro- trombincmia. Bol. Acad, argent, cir, 1941, 25: 18-26. Also Rev. cir. B. Aires, 1941, 20:427-33.—Perez Cirera, R. Vitamina K y coagulation de la sangre. Arch. lat. amer. card, .Mex., 1940 10: 133-44.—Plasma prothrombin and vitamin K. Mel! J. Australia, 1941, 1: 332.—Plum, P. K-Vitaminmangel bei Kindern. Deut. med. Wschr, 1940, 66: 1389-95 Also Bull Hyg Lond, 1941, 16: 526.—Prothrombin deficiency bleeding. Ther. Notes, Detr, 1940, 47: 9-14—Quick, A. J. The clinical significance of prothrombin as a factor in hemor- rhage. Pennsylvania M, J, 1939-40, 43: 125-30—Kafsky, H. A. Varied clinical aspects of vitamin K deficiency. Rev. Gastrocnter, 1941, 8: 472-80—Rhoads, J. E, Warren, R, & Panzer, L. M. Experimental hypoprothrombinemia. Am. J. M. Sc, 1941, 202: 847-61.—Scanlon, G. H, Brinkhous, K. M. [et al.] Plasma prothrombin and the bleeding tendency. J. Am. M. Ass, 1939, 112: 1898-1901. Also repr.—Scar- borough, H. Nutritional deficiency of vitamin K in man. Lancet, Lond, 1940, 1: 1080-2.—Snell, A. M, & Butt, H. R. Factors governing the absorption and utilization of vitamin K. Tr. Ass. Am. Physicians, 1939, 54: 38-45.—Souter, A. W., & Kark, R. Quick's prothrombin test simplified by the use of a stable thromboplastin. Am. J. M. Sc, 1940, 200: 603-7.— Sproul, E. E, & Sanders. E. K. Effect of pancreatic achylia on vitamin K absorption and prothrombin time. Am. J. Path, 1941, 17: 587.—Tocantins, L. M. Experimental hypo- prothrombinemia with anti-prothrombin serum. Proc. Soc Exp. Biol, N. Y, 1940, 43: 729-31. ---- Prothrombin deficiency, cholemic. See also Bile-ducts, Fistula; Jaundice. Castellaneta, C. *A review of some of the experimental and clinical data on the anti- hemorrhagic vitamin K with special reference to obstructive jaundice and biliary fistula [Provi- dence Hosp., Detr.] 50p. 28cm. Detr., 1940. Golcman, C. *Die Beziehungen zwischen Hamophilie, Purpura und Cholamie. 38p. 23cm. Berl., 1936. Henningsen, O. *Zur Frage der cholamischen Blutungen (klinische und experimentelle Unter- suchungen) [Giessen] 32p. 8? Homberg- Oberhessen, 1933. Verdone, A. J. *Factors associated in bleeding of jaundiced patients with special reference to vitamin K [Evangelical Hosp.] 17 1. 2 ch. 28cm. [Milwaukee] 1939. Anchelcvich, V. I). [Cholemic and acholic hemorrhages] Sovet. med, 1937, No. 4, 8-10.—Andrus, W. DeW, & Lord, J. W, jr. Clinical investigations of some factors causing prothrombin deficiencies; significance of the liver in their production and correction. Arch. Surg, 1940, 41: 596-606.— Bernhard, F. Zur Frage der Hohensonnenbestrahlung gegen die Gefahr der cholaemischen Blutung. Chirurg, 1934, 6: 704-6.—Brinkhous, K. M, & Warner, E. D. Effect of vitamin K on hypoprothrombinemia of experimental liver injury. Proc. Soc. Exp. Biol, N. Y, 1940, 44: 009. Also repr — Butt, H. R, Snell, A. M, & Osterberg, A. E. Further observa- tions on the use of vitamin K in the prevention and control of the hemorrhagic diathesis in cases of jaundice. Proc Mayo Clin, 1938, 13: 753-64.------■ Phthiocol; its therapeutic effect in the treatment of hypoprothrombinemia associated with jaundice; a preliminary report. Ibid, 1939, 14: 497-502. The preoperative and postoperative administration of vitamin K to patients having jaundice. J. Am. M. Ass, 1939, 113: 383-90.—Cohn, E. T, & Schmidt, C. L. A. Effect of choleic acid of vitamin K on prothrombin levels of bile fistula rats. Proc. Soc. Exp. Biol, N. Y, 1939, 41: 443.—Dam, H, & Glavind, J. Die Wirkung von Vitamin K bei alimentarer und experimentellokklusions-ikterischer K-Avitaminose bei Hiih- nern. Zschr. Vitaminforsch, Bern, 1940, 10: 71-9.—Flynn, J. E, & Warner, E. D. Prothrombin levels and synthetic vitamin K in obstructive jaundice in rats. Proc. Soc. Exp. Biol, N. Y, 1940, 43: 190-4.—Heller, E. Hamorrhagische Diathese ohne Ikterus bei vollstandiger ausserer Gallenfistel. Deut. Zschr. Chir, 1932, 235: 667-73.—Lebeau, R. Etude de la prothrombine, de la vitamine K et des sels biliaires. J. Hotel-Dieu Montreal, 1940, 9: 251-60.—Lucia, S. P, & Aggeler, P. M. The influence of liver damage on the plasma prothrombin concentration and the resp->ns3 to vitamin K. Am. J. M. Sc, 1941, 201: 326-40. Maksimovich, A. S. [Blood transfusion in a case of acholic hemorrhage] Russ. klin, 1928, 9: No. 48, 480-5.—Melchior, E. Zur Theorie der cholamischen Blutungen. Beitr. klin. Chir, 1927, 139: 162-9 — Reid, J. Prothrombin deficiency in disease of the liver and bile passages and its treatment with synthetic vitamin K. Brit. M. J, 1941, 1: 579-84.—Rhoads, J. E. The relation of vitamin K to'the hemorrhagic tendency in obstructive jaundice, with a report on cerophyl as a source of vitamin K. Surgery, 1939, 5: 794-808. ------& Ravdin, I. S. The control of hemorrhage in patients operated on for obstructive jaundice. Rev. Gastro- enter, 1940, 7: 169-76.—Smith, H. P. The jaundiced bleeder; control of hemorrhage with special reference to vitamin K therapy. Proc. Interst. Postgrad. M. Ass. N. America, 1939, 395_9.------& Owen, C. A. Vitamin K; its use in patients with obstructive jaundice or with biliary fistulas. Rev. Gastro- enter, 1940, 7: 520-8.—Smith, H. P, Warner, E. D. [et al.] Bleeding tendency and prothrombin deficiency in biliary fistula clogs: effect of feeding bile and vitamin K. J. Exp. M 1938 67: 911-20.—Snell, A. M. The hemorrhagic ten- dency in 'jaundice with special reference to its treatment with vitamin K. Collect. Papers Mayo Clin, 1938, 30: 58-61 — Stewart J. D. Prothrombin deficiency and the effects of HEMORRHAGIC DIATHESIS 550 HEMORRHAGIC DIATHESIS vitamin K in obstructive jaundice and biliary fistula. Ann. Surg, 1939, 109: 5S8-95.—Tamura, M, & Yano, K. Die cholaemische Purpura und die Retraktion des Blutkuchens. Hukuoka acta med, 1940, 33: 26.—Townsend, S. R, & Mills, K. S. The use of vitamin K and bile salts in the prevention and control of the haemorrhagic diathesis in obstructive jaundice; preliminary report. Canad. M. Ass. J, 1939, 41: 111-4. ---- Prothrombin deficiency, idiopathic. Rhoads, J. E., & Fitz-Hugh, T, jr. Idiopathic hypo- prothrombinemia; an apparently unrecorded condition. Am. J. M. Sc, 1941, 202: 662-70. ---- Prothrombin deficiency, neonatal. See also Melena; Newborn, Disease. Cislaghi, F. L'azione del 2 metil - 14, naftochinone, vita- mina K tipo, sulla protrombinemia del neonato. Med. ital, 1940, 21: 181-90.—Creveld, S. van [Hemophilia neonatorum temporaria] Geneesk. tschr. Ned. Indie, 1938, 78: 1154-63.— Edsall, G. The prothrombin level in early infancy: its relation to hemorrhage and other neonatal disturbances. N. Endand J. M, 1941, 224: 762-6.—Fitzgerald, J. E, cfc Webster, A. Effect of vitamin K administered to patients in labor. Am. .1. Obst, 1940, 40: 413-22.—G. Hypoprothrombinaemia haemor- rhagica neonatorum; zur Klinik des Vitamin K. Deut. med. Wsehr 1940, 66: 1334.—Garrahan, J. P, Thomas, G. F, & I.argu ia, A. E. Variaciones patologicas de la protrombina en el iceieri nacido. Arch, argent, pediat, 1941, 15: 420-31.— Gelli.s. S. S, & Lyon, R. A. The influence of the diet of the newborn infant on the prothrombin index. J. Pediat, S. Louis, 1941, 19: 495-502.—Grossman, A. M. Vitamin K for the pediatrician; with special reference to physiologic hypoprothrombinemia of newborn infants. Ibid, 1940, 16: 239-53. ------ Coagulation defects in infancy and child- hood; the frequency of hypoprothrombinemic states and their treatment with vitamin K; a reclassification of hemorrhagic hypoprothrombinemia neonatorum. Ibid, 1941, 19: 205-17.— Hnll. F. Hemorrhagic di-ea.-e of the newborn in 3 successive infants of one familv. New lloehelle IIeSp. M. Staff. Bull, N Y 1938, 1: 28-35- Heliman. I, M, A: Shettles. 1, B. Factors influencing plasma prothrombin in the newborn infant; pre- maturity and vitamin K. Bull. Johns Hopkins Hosp.. 1939, 65: 138-41.------The prophvlactic use of vitamin K in obstetrics. South. M. J, 1942, 35: 289-93.------& Moore. W. T. Far tors influencing plasma prothrombin in the newborn infant; a study of the vitamin K activity of various naphtho hydroquiiiune derivatives. Bull. Johns Hopkins Hosp, 1940 66: 379 89. -Huber. C. P, & Shrader. J. C. Blood prothrom- bin levels in the newborn. Am. J. Obst, 1941, 41: 566-7-1.— Javert, C. T.. & Moore, R. A. Prothrombin concentration in parturient women and their newborn infants. Ibid, 40: 1022-.*). ■ Johnson, G. I). The use of vitamin K in the new- born. .1. S. Carolina M. Ass, 1940, 36: 336.—Kato, K. Pro- thrombin in the blood of newly born matuie and immature infants as determined by the microprothroinbiri method Am. ,1. Dis. Child, 1940, 59: 913-6.------& Ponther, H. C. I he prothrombin in the blood of newborn mature and imma- ture infants, as determined bv the microprothrombin test J. Am. M. Ass, 1910, 114: 749-53.—Kove, S, & Siegel, H. Prothrombin in the newborn infant; relationship to the ma- ternal dietary vitamin K intake. J. Pediat, S. Louis, 1940, 17: 448-57.------Prothrombin response to water-soluble naphthoquinone administered intravenously; on the nature of prothrombin in the newborn infant. Ibid, 1941, 18: 764- 19: 503.—Larsen, H, & Plum, P. [Prevention of K-avita- minosis in the new-born by injections of vitamin K to th, mother, shortly before Pirn] Ujres.kr. laeger, 1940, 102: 1038-40.—Lawson, R. B. Treat ment of hypoprothrombinemia hemorrhagic disease, of the newborn infant. J Pediat S Louis, 1941, 18: 224-34.—Macpherson, A. I. S, McCalium E, & Haultain, W. F. T. Effect of intra-partum and neonatal administration of synthetic vitamin K analogues on the new- born. Brit. M. J, 1940, 1: 839-44.—McCready, R. L., Calla- han, E. T, & Grandin, D. J. Parenteral vitamin K therapy in ante-partum women and its effects on the infants' prothrombin levels; a preliminary report. Am. J. Obst, 1941, 42: 398- 404.—Marcus, H. [Case of hemorrhagic diathesis in the new- born treated by blood transfusion] Hygiea, Stockh, 1929 91- 10-4.—Nsslund. J. Untersuchungen uber den Fib'rinoge'nge- halt des Blutes bei Neugeborenen unter besonderer Beriick- sichtigung der Verhaltnisse bei -Haemophilia neonatorum temporaria. Acta obst. gvn. scand, 1934 14- 143-89__ Norris. R. F, & Rush A. A comparison of the prothrombin levels of maternal and cord blood at delivery. Sure Gvn Obst, 1940, 70: 1006-10, -Nygaard, K. K. Causes, treatment, and prevention of haemorrhage in newborn infants. Nutrit Abstr, Aberdeen, 1941-42, 11: 328.—Pray, L. G, McKeown H- S, & Pollard, W. E. Hemorrhagic diathesis of the newborn: 'lull aI ^SlT K P^PnyJa™ and therapy. Am. J. Obst,' 1941, 42 836-4o-Quick A J. \ itamin K for the newborn J. Am. M Ass, 1942 118: 999. ------ & Grossman, A. M Concentration of prothrombm in blood of babies (3 to 7 davs old) Proc. Soc. Exp. Biol, N. Y, 1939, 40: 617 Prothrombin concentration in newborn 'ibid 41- 227__ Rouhunkoski. M, & Saksela, N. Ueber der Hypoprothrom- binaemia neonatorum und deren Beziehungen zum K-\ itamin Acta obst. gyn. scand, 1941, 21: 203-24. Also Surg. Gvn Obst, 1942, 74: Suppl, 364-7 (Abstr.)— Salomonsen. I.'. Haemorrhagic disease of the newborn; hypoprothrombinaemia of the newborn. Nutrit. Abstr, Aberdeen, 1941-12, 11: 328 — Sanford, H. N, Shmigelsky, 1, A- Chapin. J. M. I8 the ad- ministration of vitamin K to newborn infants of clinical v due'' Am. J. Dis. Child, 1941, 62: 413-6. Also J. Am. M \NS 1942, 118: 697-702.—Savage, H. The development of vita- min K and its clinical uses in the neonatal period. Arch Dis Childh, Lond, 1941, 16: 67-70.--SeiIs, R. I,. Walker. S. A.. 4 Owen, O. A. Vitamin K requirement of the newborn infant Proc. Soc. Exp. Biol, N. Y, 1941, 47: 441 -5. -Shettles, I.. R, Delfs, E.. & Heliman, L. M. Factors influencing plasma prothrombin in the newborn infant; antepartum and neonatal ingestion of vitamin K concentrate. Bull. Johns Hopkins Hosp, 1939, 65: 419-26.--Siedentopf. E. Temporare Hiimo'- philie der Neugeborenen. Zbl. Gyn., 1929, 53: 1068-70.__ Tocantins, L. M. Probable mechanism of the physiologic hypoprothrombinemia of the newborn. Am. J. Dis. Child, 1940, 59: 1054-6,—Vitamin K can prevent fatal hemorrhage of babies; prothrombin, missing during first week of life, leaves infant exposed to dangerous bleeding. Science News Lett, 1939, 36: 7.—Vyve, A. van. Le taux de prothrombine chez le nouveau-ne. Acta brevia neerl, 1941, 11: 101-4.—Wallgren, A. [Hemorrhagic diathesis in the new-born] Sven. lak. tidn 1938, 35: 1999-2002. ---- Prothrombin deficiency: Treatment. Gulash, J. R. *Vitamin K: significance of vitamin K in hypoprothrombinemia [8. Vin- cent's Hosp.] 21p. 28cm. Bridgeport, Conn , 1940 Merck & Co. The treatment of prothrombin deficiency with 2-methyl-napthoquinone. 20 1. 27cm. Rah way, N. J., 1940. Abbott, W. E., & Holden, W. D. Prothrombin deficiencies and the use of vitamin K. Clin. Bull, Clevel, 1940, 4: 52-4.— Aggeler. P. M, Lucia, S. P, & Goldman, L. Effect of syn- thetic vi(n min K compounds on prothrombin concentration in man. Proc. Soc. Exp. Biol, N. Y, 1940, 43: 689-94.—Andrus, W. DoW„ & Lord, J. W, jr. The use of intramuscular injec- tions of 2-inelhyl-l, 4-naphthoquinone in the treatment of prothrombin deficiencies with a note on the role of the liver in the response to this and other substances with vitamin K activity. Ann. Surg, 1940, 112: 783-90. Also Tr. Am. Surg Ass, 1910, 58: 301-8. Also J. Am. M. Ass, 1940, 114: 1336. ---- 3-7. Also repr.— Tocantins, L. M, & Jones, H. W. Hypoprothrombinemia; effect of peroral and parenteral administration of a synthetic vitamin K substitute, 2-methvl-l, 4-naphthoquinone. Ann. Surg, 1941, 113: 276-83.—Toohey, M. Prothrombin; its estimation, clinical significance, and the treatment of hypo- prothrombinaemia. Irish J. M. Sc, 1941, 6. ser. No. 189, 509-32.—Townsend, S. R, & Mills, E. S. Haemorrhagic tendency associated with prothrombin deficiency and its treatment with vitamin K and bile. Canad. M. Ass. J, 1940, 42: 541-6.—Vitamina (A) antihemorragiea. Arq. biol, S. Paulo, 1942, 26: 19.—Warner, E. D. Plasma prothrombin; effect of partial hepatectomy. J. Exp. M, 1938, 68: 831-5. Also repr.—Watt, J. G. Vitamin K and prothrombin. Univ. Toronto M. J, 1940-41, 18: 266-9.—Ziffren, S. E, Owen, C. A. [et al.] Control of vitamin K therapy; compensatory mechanisms at low prothrombin levels. Proc. Soc. Exp. Biol, N. Y, 1939, 40: 595-7. Also repr. --- Purpura fulminans. Domke, G. *TJeber das Krankheitsbild der Purpura fulminans. 23p. 8? Greifsw., 1938. Ecjstermann, M. *Purpura fulminans. 34p. 8? Gott., 1926. Arana, L. C. Un caso de purpura fulminans de Henoch. Bol. Inst. elm. quir, B. Air, 1926, 2: 552-4.—Bars, F, & Le Chuiton. Sur un cas de purpura fulminans, k type de Henoch, provoquS par le m6ningocoque B. avec reaction myelocytaire. Arch. med. pharm. nav, 1928, 118: 306-13.—Battley, S. Pur- pura fulminans due to the Meningococcus; report of a case. Am. J. Dis. Child, 1927, 33: 214-8.—Boettiger, K. Zur Casuistik der Purpura fulminans. Arch. Kinderh, 1928, 85: 239-47.—Briihl, H. Beitrag zum Krankheitsbild der Purpura fulminans. Zschr. Kinderh, 1930-31, 50: 547-52.—BuIImore, H. H, Little, E. M, & Lahz, R. B. A case of fulminating purpura. Med. J. Australia, 1926, 1: 329.—Cardelli, V. Su di un caso di porpora fulminante. Rinasc. med, 1936, 13: 43.—Glanzmann, E. Zum Problem der Purpura fulminans. Schweiz. med. Wschr, 1937, 67: 829.—Harsha, G. M. Purpura fulminans (report of a case) West Virginia M. J, 1936, 32: 137.—Harvier, P, & Cattan, R. Purpura fulminans; septi- cemie k Diplococcus crassus. Bull. Soc. m6d. hop. Paris, 1931, 3. ser, 47: 611-5.—Heinlein, H. Lipamie bei Purpura fulminans. Virchows Arch, 1934-35, 294: 692-701.—Joffe, G. [Purpura fulminans] Medicina, Kaunas, 1936, 17: 448-54.— Kelly, E. H. Case of purpura fulminans following measles. Proc. R. Soc. M, Lond, 1921-22, 15: Sect. Stud Dis. Child, 45.—Kluger, W. [Unusual case of fulminating purpura har-morrhagica in an adult] Przegl. lek, Krakow, 1908, 48: 577-20.—Knauer, H. Das Krankheitsbild der Purpura ful- minans. Jahrb. Kinderh, 1927-28, 3. F, 68: 1-16, 4 pl — Kourilsky, R, Guillot, M, & Ong Sian Gwan. Etudes sur le mdcanisme des lesions hemorragiques d'origine allergique et anaphylactique; dosages in situ des substances hemorragipares. Rev. immun. Par, 1938, 4: 248-59.—Lattes, G. Su di un caso di porpora fulminante. Pediatria (Riv.) 1931, 39: 373- 84 — Leme da Fonseca, J. Um caso de purpura fulminante. Pediat. prat, S. Paulo, 1935, 6: 79-83.—Manzanera, M. Tres casos de purpura hemorrdgica fulminante de Henoch Siglo med, 1927, 74: 360.—Morawitz, P. Zum Problem der Purpura fulminans. Munch, med. Wschr, 1926, 73: 1558- 61.—Nicolussi. O. Un caso di porpora fulminante di Henoch. Oazz. osp, 1914, 35: 1910.—Peljak, F. J. [Case of purpura fulminans] Ned. tschr. geneesk, 1928, 72: 1167-70.—Pfeiffer, W. F. [Case of purpura fulminans with symmetrical hemor- rhages] Ibid, 1927, 71: pt 2, 190-2—Pratt, T. A, & Frew H. W. O. Purpura fulminans following a mild case of scarlet fever. Brit. M. J, 1929, 1: 595.—Puschel, E. Ueber die Behandlung der Purpura fulminans bei Infcktionskrankheiten, insbesondere beim Scharlach. Munch, med. Wschr, 1937, 84: 2030-2.—Pulvertaft, R. J. V. An examination of the pathological effects of streptococcal toxin and haemolysin on rabbits; with special reference to the setiology of purpura fulminans. Lancet, Lond, 1929, 2: 318-25.—Ribadeau- Dumas, L, Chabrun, J, & Dufour. Purpura fulminans meningococcique traitement par le sulfamide et le s£rum gueri- son. Arch. mid. enl., 1939, 42: 360-6. Also Bull. Soc. pediat. Paris, 1939,'37: 163-72,—Shipton, E, A„ & Beazley, R. N. Purpura fulminans: report of a case in an adult. Med. J. Australia, 1936, 1: 752. Also Med. Woman J,> 1936, 43: ---- Purpura gangraenosa. Vechsler-Verea, A. *Considerations sur les accidents gangreneux dans le purpura. 70p. 8? Par., 1909. Beinhauer, L. G. Purpura hemorrhagica gangrenosa. Am. J. Dis. Child, 1929, 38: 1013-19. Also repr.—Chevallier, P. Le purpura gangreneux. Sang, Par, 1937, 11: 337-73, pl. ---- Purpura haemorrhagica. See subheading Thrombocytopenic purpura. ---- Purpura rheumatica. See subheading Henoch-Schonlein type. ---- Purpura simplex [including hereditaria] Cipollaro, A. C. Purpura simplex. Arch. Derm. Syph, Chic, 1940, 41: 612.—Davis, E. Hereditary familial purpura simplex. Lancet, Lond, 1939, 2: 1110-5. ------ Hereditary familial purpura simplex; review of 27 families. Ibid, 1941, 1: 145.—Louste, Cailliau [et al.] Purpura simplex k Evolution chronique des membres inferieurs. Bull. Soc. fr. derm, syph, 1927, 39: 407-10.—Romulo, E. P. Purpura simplex treated successfully by Coagulen Ciba. Month. Bull. Bur. Health, Manila, 1938, 18: 121-3.—Tancre. Ein Fall von Purpura simplex. Deut. med. Wschr, 1919, 45: 367. ---- senile. Schtjermaxn, H. *Ueber generalisierte hae- morrhagische Diathesen im Greisenalter. 20p. 8? Rostock, 1933. Curschmann, H. Ueber hamorrhagische Diathesen im Greisenalter. Med. Klin, Berl, 1936, 32: 1-4.— Lorenz, W. Zur Kenntnis der hamorrhagischen Diathesen im hoheren Alter. Ibid, 1941, 37: 274-6.—Simon, C, & Bralex, J. Cas pour diagnostic; purpura senilis de Bateman? Bull. Soc. fr. derm, syph, 1929, 36: 83. ---- Surgery. See also other subheadings. Kracke, R. R. The effect of splenectomy in the purpuric diseases. South. Surgeon, 1933, 2: 203-11.—Landow. Zur Frage der Milzexstirpation bei der Gruppe der Purpura. Deut. Zschr. Chir, 1929, 216: 115-35.—Leriche, R. Spienectomie pour purpura chronique. Bull. Soc. nat. chir. Par, 1927, 53: 1132. ---- Surgical aspect. Fitz-Hugh. T, jr. Postoperative hemorrhage in hemorrhagic conditions; prognosis, prevention, and control. Med. Clin. N. America, 1929-30, 13: 889-902. Also Cyclop. Med. (Piersol- Bortz) Phila, 1939, 827-33—Kappis, M, & Mackuth, E. Klinische Beobachtungen und Untersuchungen zu den Storun- gen der Blutstillung. Deut. Zschr. Chir, 1930, 228: 1-27.— Letulle, R. De l'utilite des examens biologiques pr6-etpost- operatoires; les syndromes hemorragiques; hemophilie, hemo- genie. Presse med, 1934, 42: 1771-3. ---- Thrombasthenia [Glanzmann-Nageli] Catel, W. Differentialdiagnose der hereditiiren hamor- rhagischen Thrombasthenie. Kinderarztl. Prax, 1934, 5: 394-7 —Conitzer, E. H. Considerazioni sulle sindromi di tromboastenia essenziale di Glanzmann nei bambino. Riv. chn pediat, 1937, 35: 41-60.—Fonio, A. Blutstatus und Gerinnung bei einem Falle von infantiler hereditiirer Lhromb- asthenift nach Glanzmann. Mitt. Grenzgeb. Med. Chir, 1930- 31 42-166-77—Kohan, H. [Hemorrhagic thromboasthema] Bliss, klin, 1924, 1: pt 2, 277-86—Rothman, P. E, & Nixon, N K. Familial purpura hemorrhagica without thrombopenia; hereditary hemorrhagic thrombasthenia. J. Am. M. Ass, 1929 93- 15-7-—Strumia, M. M. Hereditary hemorrhagic thrombasthenia of Glanzmann. In Cyclop. Med. (Piersol- Bortz) Phila, 1939, 2: 805. ---- Thrombocytopenic purpura. See also subheadings Waterhouse-Friderichsen syndrome; Werlhof's disease. # Bomeier, G. *Thrombopenische haemor- rhagische Diathesen. 48p. 21cm. Rostock, Isch-Wall, P. L hemogeme (diathese hemor- ragipare) etude clinique. 310p. 8°. Par. 1926. Adelman, M. Purpura hemorrhagica. Rhode Island M. J, 1936, 19: 9-11.—Alfonso y Armenleros, iJ. Purpura hemo- HEMORRHAGIC DIATHESIS 5)2 HEMORRHAGIC DIATHESIS rn'igira. Rev. med. cir. Habana, 1934, 39: 362-74.—Arnold, C. H, 4 HEMORRHAGIC DIATHESIS acute rlneu litis. Med. Clin. X. America, 1928, 12: 215-24 — Valle. I, R. Consideraciones acerca de un caso de purpura hemorrdgica en una tuberculosis pulmonar. Dfa mdd, B. Air, 1929-30, 2: 505.- -Valoquia. Purpura hemorragiea en el curso de una fiebre p:dudie-i continua, de forma grave. Mem. Congr. m.d. nac. mix., 191 >. 4. Congr, 431-6.—Vega, M. de la, Machado Espinosa. M, & Manrique Sanchez, M. Purpura tromhopdnica en el curso de una tuberculosa ganglionar. Anion mdd, B. Air, 1939, 9: 615-21.—Weber, F. P. Chronic purpura of 2 years' duration connected with malignant endo- carditis wrongly supposed to be connected with splenic anaemia. Brit, J. Derm, 1910, 22: 37-43.—Welt, B„ & Kasnetz, .1. Thrombopenic purpura as complication; association with mute mastoiditis, lateral sinus thrombosis, Streptococcus viridans bacteremia and multiple metastatic abscesses. Arch. Otolar, Chic, 1938, 27: 732-8.—Wolff, S. Werlhofsyndrom als Folge einer Paratvphus-B-Sepsis bei einem 6 Monate alten Kinde. Zschr. Kinderh, 1931-32, 52: 161-1. Zucal, E, & Gustavino, D. Trombopenia sintomatica en un lactante; otorragia bilateral postparacentesis. Arch, argent, pediat.. 1937. 8: 55-60. ---- Thrombocytopenic purpura: Hematology. See also Agranulocytosis; Anemia, aplastic; Erythroblastosis; Leukosis, &c. Adelheim, R. Ueber maligne thrombopenische Purpura (Aleucia haemorrhagica) Beitr. path. Anat, 1930, 84: 283- 98.—Baehr, G, Klemperer, P., & Schifrin, A. An acute febrile anemia and thrombocytopenic purpura with diffuse platelet, thromboses of capillaries and arterioles. Tr. Ass. Am. I'liy.-iciaus, 1930, 51: 43-58.—D'Agata, G, & Baroni, B. Kmaturia in caso di porpora trombopenica da carcinosi del midollo o--eo. Arch. Soc. ital. chir, 1931, 37: 684-7.— Deganello, l'. Porpora emorragica e anemia aplastica acuta; eonti-ibuto clinico e auatomo-istologico. Gazz. osp, 1909, 30: S25-30. Ervin, J. W. A case of thrombocytopenia with leukopenia of unknown origin. South. M. & S, 1940, 102: 129.—Fieschi, A. II midollo osseo in alcune splenopatie croniche con anemia e leuco-trombopenia. Gazz. osp, i938, 59: 913 8.—Fiessinger, N, Thiebaut, F. [et al.] Syndrome he'-nun lagique d'origine spldnique. Bull. Soc. mdd. hop. l'am, 19 10, r,6: 175-81.—Fleischhacker, H. Ueber Tlnomhopenien i Kiiiteilung und Knochcnmarksbefundc) Wien. klin. Wschr, 1937. .»<»: 1480-3.—Friesz, J. [Ten cases of aleukia hemor- rhagica] Orv. hetil, 1929, 73: 1312-1.—Leboun.'. L, Weill, J, & Frechin. Purpura hdmorragique avec andnne et granulo- cytopenic; stomatite gangrdneuse avec ndcrose du rebord alvdolaire; gudrison aprds transfusions rdpdtdes et extractions des 4 dent- de sagesse. Rev. stomat. Par, 1936, 38: 181-93.— Major, R. H„ & Weber, C. J. Is there a platelet-reducing -ubstance in the spleen of thrombocytopenic purpura? J. Lib. Clin. M, 1939 40, 25: 10 3. Markov. N. Das Knochen- mark bei tin oinbopenischer Purpura. Med. Welt, 1938, 12: 770- 3.—Minot, G. R. A non-fatal ca>e simulating acute leukemia with anemia and thrombopenic purpura. Med. Clin. N. America, 1929, 13: 1-9.—Navarro. J. C, & de Elizalde, F. Trombopenia maligna. Arch, argent, pediat, 1935, 6: 578- 83.—Neumann, O. Ein Fall von thrombopenischer Purpura mit Ausgang in aplastische Anamie. Zschr. Kinderh, 1937, 59: 124-8.—Nygaard, K. K. Coagulability of the blood plasma and changes in the number of platelets in thrombocytopenic purpura. Proc. Mayo Clin, 1934, 9: 492-6.—Sannicandro, G. Purpura emorragica ed adenopatia generahzzata simulante una leucemia linfatica acuta, espressione di una mielosi aplastica parziale leucoplastrinopenica di natura sifilitica (stato attuale delle purpure e contributo clinico ed istologico) Gior. ital. derm, sif, 1927, 68: 1529-46.—Spleen (The) in thrombocyto- penic purpura. J. Med, Cincin, 1938-39, 19: 59.—Tocantins, L. M. Experimental thrombopenic purpura; cytological and physical changes in the blood. Ann. Int. M, 1935-36, 9: 838-49. Also repr. ------ Physicochemical changes oi the blood in experimental thrombopenic purpura. Proc. Soc. Exp. Biol, N. Y, 1937-38, 36: 402-0. Also repr. ------ & Cantarow, A. The plasma lipids in purpura produced with antiplatelet serum. J. Immun, Bait, 1936, 30:261-6.—Troland, C. E, & Lee, F. C. A preliminary report on a platelet-reducing substance in the spleen of thrombo-cytopenic purpura. Bull. Johns Hopkins Hosp, 1938, 62: 85.—Ungar, M. [Malignant thrombopenia] Polska gaz. lek, 1930, 9: 659.—Weil, P. E, & Scemama. Un cas de cryptoleucemie d'aspect hdmogdnique, spldnectomise pour hdmorragies; dvolution ultdrieure d'une leucdmie lymphatique k forme hdmorragique. Sang, Par 1936. 10: 372-7.—Weill, J, Lebourg, I., & Frechin. Purpura hemorragique avec andmie et granulocytopenic. Bull. Soc med. hop. Paris, 1935, 3. ser, 51: 1540-8.—Weiner, J. J ., & Carter, R. F. Acute thrombocytopenic purpura hemorrhagica associated with tuberculosis, military, of the spleen; splen- ectomy, recovery. Ann. Surg, 1941, 113: 57-61.—Willi, H. Leber den Bau und die Funktion der Megakaryocyten und ihre Beziehungen zur thrombopenischen Purpura. Fol. haemat Lpz, 1934-35, 53: 426-39. ---- Thrombocytopenic purpura: Manifesta- tion. Spahv, E. *Ueber Thrombopenie unter besonderer Berucksichtigung der Veranderungen in der Mundhohle [Heidelberg] 2.">p. 20,icrn (Jladbock, 1937. Arhmatowicz, L. [Enteritis and hemorrhagic peritonitis in purpura hemorrhagica] Polska gaz. lek, 1931. 10: 139.- Al.ijouanine. T, Thurel, R, & Mauric. G. I'aral\ let pcriphdri- ques des membres inferieurs au cours d'un purpura liemor- ragi.pic. Rey. neur. Par., 1933, 40: 501-4.- Vipers. B. J, ,t Duane, W., jr. Intracranial hemorrhage in purpura hemor- rhagica. .1. Nerv. Ment. Dis, 1933, 78: 260 73.- -Ilil/.er, K, :>s HEMORRHAGIC DIATHESIS Fernandez, A. A, & Iapalucci. L. Sindrome purpurico; vascularitis. Sem. mdd, B. Air, 1936, 41: pt 2, 728-32. Also Rev. As. mdd. argent, 1936, 50: 21 tiii-13.—Gaucher, E, & Flurin. Purpura chronique aiigioselereux. Bull. Soc. fr. derm. syph, 1910, 21: 36.--Gaucher. E, & Joltrain. Purpura chronique de l'angiosclerose. Ibid, 1909, 20: 244.—Holmgren, I, & b>ttkens, H. Etude sur la fragilitd vasculaire. Acta ined. scand, 1933, 80: 575-87.—Kugelmass, I. N. Vitamin P in vascular purpura. J. Am. M. Ass, 1940, 115: 519.—Sack. G. Beitrag zur vascularen Purpura und ein neuer Vorschlag zur Behandlung. Deut. Arch. klin. Med, 1939-40, 185: 186-91.— Schmidt, J. Geheilter Fall einer schweren athrombopenischen Purpura mit Hautnekrosen und symptomischer Agranulocy tose. KUn. Wschr, 1935, 14: 1245-7. ------ [Athmmbopenic purpura with agranulocytosis] Orv. hetil, 1935, 79: 755-7. ---- Waterhouse-Friderichsen syndrome. Rothschild, H. *Ueber zwei Falle von Pur- pura haemorrhagica mit septischem Verlauf. 32p. 8? Lpz., 1908. Kamber, A. Beitrag zum Syndrom von Waterhouse-Fride- richsen. Mschr. Kinderh, 1937, 71: 351-73.—Levinson, S. A. The Waterhouse-Friderichsen syndrome; report of a case with autopsv findings. J. Pediat, S. Louis, 1939, 14: 506-16.— Monfort, J. A, & Mehrling, J. H. The Waterhouse-Fride- richsen syndrome; review of the literature and report of a case with autopsy. Am. J. Dis. Child, 1941, 62: 144-9. ---- Werlhof's disease. See also subheading Thrombocytopenic pur- pura. Karr, J. K. ^Essential thrombocytopenic purpura. 30p. Milwaukee, Wis., 1936. Ossenberg, W. *Die essentielle Thrombo- penie; Morbus maculosus Werlhofii [Rostock] 19p. 22cm. Bethel-Bielefeld, 1936. Ainsworth, M. L, Edelman, S. D, & Fried, R. I. Thrombo- cytopenic purpura hemorrhagica. J. Pediat, S. Louis, 1937, 11: 559-62.—Bcnitez, L. El sindroma de Werlhof. Arch. lat. amer. pediat., B. Air, 1908, 4: 73-83.—Chevallier, P., & Coldberg, It. La grandc hdmogenie idiopathique. Rev. mdd. Par, 1 '.»:-$."», 52: 16-46.—Cuomo. G. Sul morbo di Werlhof. Pediatria (Riv.) J933, 41: 193-202.—Davanzo, I. G, & David, D. bul morbo di Werlhof. Minerva med. Tor, 1937, 28: pt 2, 559-64.—Del Sei, M. Hemogenia. Prensa mdd. argent, B. Air, 1927, 14: 366-72. Also Rev. Soc. med. int., B. Air, 1928, 4: 73-88.—Gasbarrini, A. Morbo maculoso di Werlhof Baglivi, 1938, 4: 69-81.—Geggie, C. G. Essential thrombo- cytopenic purpura hemorrhagica. Canad. M. Ass. J, 1926, 16: 155-7.—Gillin, H. Z. Essential thrombocytopenic purpura. Internat. Clin, 1936, 46. ser, 4: 95-119.—Gimena & Benitez de Huelva. Trombopenia esencial. Med. ibera, 1936, 30: pt 2, 332-4.—Green, M. T. Purpura hemorrhagica; essential thrombocytopenia. Tristate M. J, 1933, 5: 1062-4.—Green- wald, H. M, & Sherman, I. Congenital essential thrombo- cytopenia. Am. J. Dis: Child, 1929, 38: 1245-51. Also repr.— Hall, W. E. B. Essential thrombocytopenic purpura. Clin M. & S, 1938, 45: 113.—Haridas, G. Essential thrombo- cytopenia. J. Malay. Brit. M. Ass, 1940, 4: 198-204.— Hodges, A. B. Essential thrombocytopenia (purpura hemor- rhagica) Virginia M. Month, 1926-27, 53: 582-8.—Hoglund, G. De la thrombopdnie essentielle. Acta med. scand,~192o' Suppl, 16: 611-7 —Isch-Wall, P. L'hdmogdnie. Rev. prat' mal. pays chauds, 1926, 6: 359-89.—Jones, H. W. Purpura, with particular reference to essential thrombocytopenia (pur- pura hemorrhagica) Med. Clio. N. America, 1929-30, 13: 1037-45.—Kalmar, A. Morbus maculosus Werlhofii ds purpura haemorrhagicarol. Budapesti orv. ujs, 1909, 7: 880-2.— Kohlbry, C. O. Essential thrombocytopenic purpura. Minne- sota M, 1935, 18: 15-20.—Koster, H. Essential thrombo- cytopenic purpura; etioligy. pathogenesis, pathognomonic symptoms, diagnosis and operative treatment. Med J & Rec, 1927, 125: 23; 97; 167.—Lapiccirella, V. L'emogenia Riv. clin. med, 1927, 28: 720.—Lytle, C. C, & Ward, D. V. Idiopathic thrombopenic purpura. J. Iowa M. Soc 1937 27- 296; 377.—Meirelles, E. Purpura de Werlhof. Brasil med ' 1917, 31: 6.—Myers, B. Essential (thrombocytopenic) pur- pura haemorrhagica. Am. J. Dis. Child, 1935 49- 543-9 Also Brit. M. J, 1935, 2: 44.5-8.— Pakozdy, K. [Thrombo- penia purpura (\\ erlhof's disease)] Orv. hetil, 1926, 70: 2-4 — £?rHLrV-G-„T p"rP,ura haemorrhagica; morbus 'maculosus V\erlhofii. N. York M. J, 1914, 100: 132.—Potts, R. H, & Strahan, R. M. Purpura hemorrhagica vera. N Orleans'm & S. J, 1929-30 82: 611-5.—Preziosi, T. Sul morbo maculoso emorragico di Werlhof. Ann. chn. Osp. incurab. Nap 1836 2: 231-40— Rabuffetti, L. U. Enfermedad de Werlhof. Accioii med, B. Air 1940, 10: 605.—Ricci, F. Sul morbo di Werlhof Rilorma med, 1928 44: 912-6.-Sabatini, L. Le cosidette porpore iiriiintive. Pohchnico, 1926, 33: sez prat 1739-43__ Sanford, H. N, Leslie, E. I, & Crane, M. M." Congenital thrombocytopenia. Am. J. Dis. Child, 1936 51- 1114-8 — H x\ll -lm~i^rfaub'J: [VVerlhols disease] Orv. hetil, 1929 16. uu^-o.—bzyfinan, L. [.lhrombopenia essentialis] Polska gaz. lek, 1926. 5: 47 9. -T, R. M. Hdmogdnie et purpura Praxis, Bern, 1934, 23: 399 lui. Torday. A. |\Vcrlhof'<' disease] Budapesti orv. ujs, 1930, 31: 301-4.—Thorliug, I [Morbus maculosus Werlhofi] Ilygira, Stockh, 1931, itfij 211.—Volpe, A. Purpura trombopdnica de Werlhof. Arch pediat. Iruguay, 1935, 6: 403-7. ---- Werlhof's disease, acute. Le M irquand, H. S, & Mills, J. Acute idiopathic purpurn haemorrhagica 14 months after splenectomy. Proc. R. Soc. M, Lond, 1933, 26: 358.------Acute idiopathic purpura haemorrhagica, 2 years and 10 months after splenectomv Ibid, 359. ---- Werlhof's disease: Casuistics. Engelhard, W. *Ein Fall von Morbus maculosus Werlhofii mit ungewohnlichem Aus- gang [Heidelberg] 24p. 8? Munch., 1905. Johannis, W. *Ueber eine Beobachtung von essentieller Thrombozytopenie. 19p. 8? Griin- berg, 1937. Siebels, B. *Ueber einen Fall von essentieller Thrombopenie. 17p. 8? Giessen, 1928. Arrigoni, A, & Calabresi, M. Contributo alio studio del morbo di Werlhof. Haematologica, Pavia, 1929, 10: 245 301, 2 pl.—Bradford, W. H. Idiopathic thrombocytopenic purpura' report of a case. Med. Bull. Veterans Admin, 1936, 13: 273.— Elizalde, F. de. Contribucion clinica al estudio de la enfer- medad de Werlhof. Sem. mdd, B. Air, 1932, 39: 1100-19.— Figueras, J. A. Dos casos de purpura hemorragiea enfermedad de Werlhof. Rev. mdd. cubana, 1911, 19: 136-40.—Figueiredo Cortes, J. Observagao de um caso de enfermidade de Werlhof Hospital, Rio, 1939, 16: 169-78.—Greenwald, H. M. Essential thrombocytopenia; report of a case in an infant aged 4 months Am. J. Dis. Child, 1927, 33: 900-4.—Guttfreund, A. Zwei Falle von Morbus Werlhof im Siiuglingsalter. Mschr. Kinderh 1933, 56: 436-48.—Hamilton, W. F, & Waugh, T. R. Further observations on essential thrombocytopenia. Tr. Ass Am Physicians, 1925, 40: 246-62. Also Ann. Clin. M, 1925, 4: 449-62.—Hauer. Ein Fall von Morbus maculosus Werlhofii bei einer 72 jahrigen. Med. Klin, Berl, 1913, 9: 212-4 — Hellerstrom. Fall von Morbus maculosus Werlhofi; purpura haemorrhagica idiopathica oder essentielle Thrombopenie. Acta derm, vener, Stockh, 1935, 16: 96.—Holten, C. Observa- tions on idiopathic thrombocytopenic purpura. Acta med. scand., 1938, 96: Suppl. 90, 208-30.—Kossak, J. [Case of Werlhof's disease] Przegl. lek, Krakow, 1909, 48: 371.— Kutschera. Fall von primarer, essentieller Thrombopenie. Wien. med. Wsehr, 1927, 77: 260.—Langert, S. Ein Fall von essentieller Thrombopenie. Acta paediat, Upps, 1939, 26: 212-57.—Lellis, A. Estados hemogenicos (casos clinicos) Brasil med, 1925, 39: pt 2, 180.—Lightwood, R. C. Thrombo- cytopenic type of primary purpura in an infant of 5 weeks. Brit. J. Child. Dis, 1935, 32: 49.—Marin, P. Sulla malattia di Werlhof. Haematologica, Nap, 1927, 8; 47-89.—Maxwell, R. II, & Smith, L. B. Early essential thrombocytopenia (so-called nurpura hemorrhagica) J. Kansas M. Soc, 1934, 35: 51.— Milano, G. Morbo maculoso di Werlhof o porpora trombo- penica essenziale. Fol. med. Nap, 1928, 14: 4.30-48.— Mnatsakanov, I. I. K kazuistikle morbi maculosi Werlhofii. Med. obozr, Moskva, 1912, 78: 517-30, 2 pl.—Moore, J. H. Idiopathic purpura hemorrhagica; report of case. J. Lancet, 1929, 49: 154.—Moraes, A. de. Caso de hemogenia. Bol. Soc. obst. gin. B. Aires, 1936, 15: 713-21.—Moreira, R. Diathese hemorragiea na infancia (a respeito de um caso de purpura de Werlhof) Brasil med, 1932, 46: 767.—Poinso, R, & Jouglard, J. L hemogeme diathdsique (k propos de 9 observations) Sang, Par, 1930, 4: 753-62.—Pombo y Ruiz, N. Un caso clinico de purpura hemorragiea (enfermedad de Werlhof) Gac. mdd. Sur Espafia, 1912, 30: 414.—Pujadas y Ortiz, G. Un caso de enfermedad de Werlhof. Rev. mdd. cubana, 1926, 37: 1332- :*;,—Quioc, G- A propos d'un cas de maladie de Werlhof. 7 «3u?i /j' 1911, 6: 826 — Ravarit, G. Deux cas de maladie de Werlhof dans la meme familie, a quinze jours d'intervalle sous le meme toit. Gaz. hop, 1908, 81: 1683-5.—Rozen- blattowna, H. [CUnical contribution to Werlhof's disease] Przegl. pediat, Warsz, 1911, 3: 253-5.—Schupfer, F. Sopra un caso di morbo maculoso del Werlhof. Minerva med. Tor, 1934, 25: 1-11.—Stern, R, & Hartmann, E. Zur Klinik der essentiellen Thrombopenie. Zschr. klin. Med, 1926, 104: 49d-5. Strom, J. Three cases of morbus maculosus Werlhofii, Acta paediat, Upps, 1933-34, 15: 112-7. Also Hygiea, •\K>ckh, 1931, 96: 212-5. ------ Thrombopenische Purpura (Morbus maculosus Werlhofii) im ersten Lebensjahre (Be- Vno^-oi"18 zweier Falle bei Sauglingen) Acta paediat, Upps, 1930-37, 19: 540-52— Velasco Blanco, L, Copello, O, & Echegaray, E. M. Consideraciones sobre un caso de enfer- medad de Werlhof o hemogenia o trombocitopenia. Arch. amer med, B. Air, 1934, 10: 123-8.—Vincenti, A. Ln cas de maladie de Werlhof. BuU. Soc. mdd. Vaucluse, Avignon, 1910, 6: 4o8-61. ---- Werlhof's disease, chronic. . Berghausen, O. Chronic purpura hemorrhagica. Cin- cinnati J. M, 1920, 1: 205.—Boncinelli, U. Un caso di porpora HEMORRHAGIC DIATHESIS intermittente cronica. Arch. ital. derm, 1938, 14: 134-53.— Castro Freire, L. de. Sur l'indication opdratoire dans la purpura chronique, trombocitopenique, chez les enfants. Acta pddiat, Upps, 1931, 11: 212-6 [Discussion] 223.—Cavallucci, U. Sulla porpora cronica apiastrinica. Rinasc. med, 1930, l'. 187-9 2 pl.—Cohen, A. E. Chronic intermittent purpura; report of' case. Kentucky M. J, 1929, 27: 74-7.—Collier, J. Chronic purpura. Proc. R. Soc. M, Lond, 1908-9, 2: Clin. Sect, 27.—Edgeworth, F. H. Cases of chronic purpura with and without cutaneous lesions. Brit. _M. J, 1912, 1: 715.— Ferrata, A, & Storti, E. Sindrome Werlhofiana cronicissima, piastrino-neutropenica, con aplasia mieloide terminale; dis- cussione su un eventuale fattore di neutropenia costituzionale. Gazz. osp, 1938, 59: 855-8.—Froehlich, A. A propos d'un cas de purpura rdcidivant et svmetrique. In Libro de oro M. R. Castex, B. Air.. 1939, 3: 1633-8— Gregoire, R. A propos du purpura chronique rdcidivant. Bull. Soc. nat. chir. Par, 1929, 55: 968-73.—Hadley, H. G. Snake venom therapy of chronic thrombocytopenic purpura. Med. Rec, N. Y, 1940, 152: 391.—Hartfall, S. J, & Oldfield, C. Severe monorrhagia due to chronic thrombocytopenic purpura, cured by splenec- tomy. Brit. M. J, 1934, 2: 8.—Hausner, E. Ueber einen kasuistischen Beitrag zur Frage der chronischen essentiellen Thrombopenie. Wien. khn. Wschr, 1933, 46: 204-6.— Holler, G, & Feuerlicht, N. Ein kasuistischer Beitrag zum Krankheitsbild der chronischen essentiellen Thrombopenie. Wien. med. Wschr, 1935, 85: 652; 686.—Jedlicka, V, & Altschuller, G. Chronic essential thrombopenia (Frank) report of 2 cases with remarks about its pathogenesis. Acta med. scand, 1926, 64: 123-41, 2 pl.—Koehler, G. D. Ein Fall von chronisch hamorrhagischer Diathese bei essentieller Thrombo- penie. Klin. Wschr, 1927, 6: 314.—Lautier, H. H., Oberling, C, & Woringer, P. Contribution k l'dtude du purpura chro- nique avec thrombopdnie. Rev. fr. pddiat, 1927, 3: 341-52, pl.—Lewin, E. M. Zur Klinik der Purpura; ein Fall von konstitutioneller Purpura (Franksche Form) Derm. Wschr, 1928, 86: 749-55.—Longchampt, J. Purpura chronique (protopathique de Hayem) Bull. Soc. pddiat. Paris, 1928, 26: 43-6.—Mandelstam, M. [Pathogenesis and treatment of chronic purpura] Vrach. gaz, 1923, 27: 394-6.—Marquezy, R. A. Le traitement du purpura hemorragique chronique. Paris mdd, 1928, 69: 468-73.—Mayo, W. J, & Johnson, A. C. Recurring epistaxis from chronic hemorrhagic purpura. Surg. Clin. N. America, 1926, 6: 1123-7— Rimoldi, A. A. Purpura trombopdnica cr6nica tratada con vitamina C. Arch, argent. pediat, 1937, 8: 100-12. Also Sem. mdd, B. Air, 1937, 44: 1084-90.—Rodriguez Castro, A, & Volpe, A. Purpura cr6nica trombocitopdnica (Werlhof) Arch, pediat. Uruguay, 1937, 8: 316-21.—Schwensen, C. [Case of chronic essential thrombo- penia] Ugeskr. laeger, 1928, 90: 753.—Scremini, P. Purpura hemorrdgica cronica. Dfa mdd, B. Air, 1938, 10: 57-60.— Ugenburg, A, & Funstein, L. V. [Pathogenesis of chronic, essential thrombopenia] Sovet. vrach. gaz, 1933, 37t 1129- 32. ---- Werlhof's disease: Diagnosis. Elliott, R. H. E. Diagnostic and therapeutic considerations in the management of idiopathic thrombocytopenic purpura. Bull. N. York Acad. M, 1939, 15: 197-210.—Holten, C, & Munkholm, I. [Sternal puncture in purpura thrombopenica idiopathica (Mb. maculosus Werlhofi)J Nord. med, 1940, 5: 332-4.—Simonin, C. Une affection mddico-ldgale: la maladie de Werlhof. Ann. mdd. leg, 1936, 16: 499-504 — Wiseman, B. K, Doan, C. A, & Wilson, S. J. The present status of thrombocytopenic purpura; with special reference to diagnosis and treatment. J. Am. M. Ass, 1940, 115: 8-13. Also repr.) ---- Werlhof's disease: Etiology. Calhoun, A. D. Hereditary purpura hemorrhagica. Week. Bull. S. Louis M. Soc, 1934, 28: 534.—Davidson, L. T. Con- genital thrombopenia. Am. J. Dis. Child, 1937, 54: 1324-7.— Di Paola, G. Enfermedad de Werlhof y hormona folicular. Bol. Soc. obst. gin. B. Aires, 1936, 15: 478-88.—Funkstein, L. Die chronische essentielle Thrombopenie und das endokrine System. Deut. Arch. klin. Med, 1933, 175: 146-56.—Judica Cordiglia, G. Morbo di Werlhof traumatieo? Gazz. med. lombarda, 1932, 91: 2.—Lockhart-Mummery, J. P. Haemor- rhagic purpura (essential thrombocytopenia) as a complication of excision of the rectum. Proc. R. Soc. M, Lond, 1938-39, 32: Sect. Surg, Sub-Sect. Proct, 1488.—Nitti, R. Contributo all'etiologia del morbo di Werlhof. Pediatria (Riv.) 1930, 44: G35-46 — Poletaev, A. [Etiology of Werlhof's disease] Vrach. gaz, 1913, 20: 431-33.—Wiskott, A. Familiarer, angeborener Morbus Werlhofii? Mschr. Kinderh, 1937, 68: 212-6. ---- Werlhof's disease: Hematology. Blacher, L. [Investigations on the pathogenesis of essential thrombopenia; the significance of the spleen according to the author's experiments] Polskie arch. med. wewn, 1934, 12: 24-58.—Ferrata, A, & Storti, E. Sindrome de Werlhoff, muy cr6nico, con trombopenia, neutropenia y aplasia mieloide terminal. Rev. mdd. cubana, 1939, 50: 137-42.—Fieschi, A. Isolamento di una sostanza insaponificabile dalla milza in un caso di morbo di Werlhof. Boll. Soc. ital. biol. sper, 1935, 10: 46. ------& Villalobos, S. F. Studio dei megacariociti nella trombopenia emorragica cronica, morbo di Werlhof. Haema- HEMORRHAGIC DIATHESIS tologica, Pavia. 1939, 20: 535-60.—Kristiansen, K. [Werlhof's disease with splenic hypoplasia] Norsk, mag. laegevid, 1935 98: 1060-7.—Lawrence, J. S, & Knutti, R. E. The bone marrow in idiopathic thrombopenic purpura. Am. J. M. Sc, 1934, 188: 37-41, 2 pl.—Lewis, D. Essential thrombopenia, splenogenous thrombolytic purpura thrombocytopenic pur- pura. Northwest M, 1928, 27: 261-3.—Limarzi, L. R, & Schleicher, E. M. The reaction of peripheral blood and bone marrow in chronic hemorrhage and in essential thrombopenic purpura. J. Am. M. Ass, 1940, 114: 12-8.—Marras, S. Contribuzione alio studio anatomo-patologico della milza nei morbo del Werlhof. Arch. ital. anat. pat, 1931, 2: 161-76, a pl.—Marzollo, E. Sindrome di diatesi emorragica del gruppo Werlhof con atipico reperto ematologico. Haematologica, Pavia, 1938, 19: 923-7.—Paul, J. T. The effect of splenic extracts from cases of essential thrombocytopenic purpura on the platelets and hematopoietic organs of rabbits. J. Lab. Clin. M, 1941-42, 27: 754-62.—Peratoner, U. Morbo di Werlhof e reperto splenico. Haematologica, Pavia, 1933, 14: 453-7.—Pohle, F. J, & Meyer, O. O. Inability to demonstrate a platelet reducing substance in an acetone extract of the spleen from patients with idiopathic thrombocytopenic purpura. J. Clin. Invest, 1939, 18: 537-41.—Poinso, R, & Jouglard, J. L'irrdtractilitd du caillot dans l'hemogdnie congdnitale. Mar- seille mdd, 1931, 68: 312-9.—Tangredi, G. Morbo maculoso di Werlhof e anemia ipocromica achilica. Haematologica, Pavia, 1940, 22: 135-43.—Tocantins, L. M. No platelet- destroying action in extracts of the spleen and urine of patients with chronic thrombopenie purpura. Proc. Soc. Exp. Biol, N. Y, 1939, 42: 485.—Troland, C. E, & Lee, F. C. Thrombo- cytopen, a substance in the extract from the spleen of patients with idiopathic thrombocytopenic purpura that reduces the number of blood platelets. J. Am. M. Ass, 1938, 111: 221-6.— Wahlberg, J. [Histophysiological picture of the reticulo- endothelial svstem of the spleen in essential thrombopenia] Fin. lak. sail, hand., 1935, 78: 557-76. Also Arb. Path. Inst. Helsingfors, 1935, n. F., 8: 206-24.—Watson, G. M. The blood platelets and splenic extracts. Brit. M. J, 1941, 1: 704-6.—Weil, P. E. Les variations du temps de saignement dans l'hemogdnie. Vie med, 1922, 3: 607-11.—Zitzmann, K. Isolierte Megakaryophthise als Ursache einer essentiellen Thrombopenie. Fol. haemat, Lpz, 1936, 56: 129-46. ---- Werlhof's disease: Manifestation. Hubner, L. [B.] *Die essentielle Thrombo- penie in ihrer Bedeutung fiir den Zahnarzt. 56p. 21cm. ■ Bresl., 1937. Bertola, V. J, Girardet, O. E, & Sala, F. Purpura hemo- rragiea trombocitopdnica; relato de un caso a predominio genital; copiosas metrorraglas; esplenectomia; curaci6n. Prensa med. argent, 1940, 27: 597-601.—Berutti, E. Sindromi trombopeniche primitive e forme ostetrico-ginecologiche. Ginecologia, Tor, 1935, 1: 579-96.—Bozzi, E. Manifestazioni emorragiche della bocca e delle vie aeree superiori nei morbo di Werlhof. Arch. ital. otol, 1933, 44: 93-108.—Casa, G. Al- terazioni oculari in soggetto con morbo di Werlhof. Boll. ocul, 1936, 15: 871-89.—Chevallier, P, & Gorse, J. Hdmor- ragies cutandes (cuir chevelu, conduit auditif, oeil, ombilic) chez une petite hdmogdnique. Sang, Par, 1936, 10: 84r-6.— Dunlop, H. A. Essential haemorrhagic purpura, with transient mid-brain symptoms. Practitioner, Lond, 1934, 132: 709-11.— Evang, K. A case of essential thrombopenia (Morb. Werlhof) with huematomyelia. Acta psychiat. neur, Kbh, 1928, 3: 7-22. ------ [A case of essential thrombopenia (Morb. Werlhof) with hrematomyelia] Norsk mag. tegevid, 1928, 89: 153-64.—Freire, M. A, & Bustos, A. Un caso de enfer- medad de Werlhof con sintomatologfa preferentemente genital. Dia mdd, B. Air, 1935, 7: 1498-501. Also Prensa mdd. argent, 1936, 23: 1546-54.—German, F. F. Morbus macu- losus Werlhofii. Vest, oft, 1910, 27: 682.—Gottron, H. Das Erscheinungsbild der Purpura Werlhofi an Haut und Schleimhiiuten. Med. Klin, Berl, 1936, 32: 1725-7, pl — Gremme. A. Ueber Ursache und Ursprung von Genitalblu- tungen der Frau bei der essentiellen Thrombopenie (Frank) Arch. Gyn, Berl, 1932, 149: 515-28.—Harnisch. Schwere Blutungen bei essentieller Thrombopenie. Deut. zahniirztl. Wschr, 1940, 43: 229-32.—Herzfeld, E, & Rohrschneider, W. Doppelseitige Stauungspapille bei Werlhofscher Krankheit. Med Klin, Berl, 1927, 23: 790. Isch-Wall, P. Aspects cliniques de l'hemogdnie. Nutrition, Par, 1933, 3: 621-9.— Israel, S. L, & Mendell, T. H. Severe menorrhagia as the only symptom of essential thromboevtopenic purpura cured bv splenectomy. Am. J. Obst, 1939, 38: 339-41.—Liveriero, E. Singolare reperto di soffusioni emorragiche della membrana timpanica in un caso di trombopenia essenziale (morbo macu- loso di Werlhof) Ann. laring. Tor, 1933, 33: 89-94.—Malkina, M G. [Case of Werlhof's disease with cerebral hemorrhage] Klin, med, Moskva, 1933, 2: 1138-40.—Melo Filho, G. de. Hemogenia. Rev. brasil. otorinolar, 1939, 7: 5-26.—Nobe- court, P. Syndrome hdmorragique avec hdmatdmdses rdpdtdes chez une fille hdmogdnique de 5 ans. Rev. gdn. clin. thdr, 1936, 50: 433-9.—Oneto, J. A. Complicaciones oculares en un caso de enfermedad de Werlhof, trombopenia esencial. Rev. espec, B. Air, 1931, 6: 77-84.—Payan, L. Sur un cas d'hdmogdnie; purpura rdcidivant dans I'enfance; inondation pdritondale; mdnorragies rebelles ayant entraind la mort. Bull. Soc. mdd. hop. Paris, 1926, 3. ser, 50: 233-9.—Schussler, HEMORRHAGIC DIATHESIS 560 HEMORRHAGIC DIATHESIS I). Beitrag zur Purpura Werlhofi. Arch. Derm. Syph, Berl, 1937 175: 412-S—Sporl, H. J. Mitteilung iiber Werlholschc Kraiikh.it und Hirnblutung. Jahrb. Kinderh, 1935-36, 3. F, 96: 39 42.—Thorling, I. Some observations on morbus maculosus Werlhofii. Acta paediat, Upps, 1933-34, 15: [Discussion] 112.—Traub. E. Ueber das Vorkommen von Gehiriiblutungen beim Morbus Werlhof. Zschr. Kinderh, 1936, 58: 67-72.—Watanabe. S. Meningeal hemorrhage in a boy of idiopathic thromboevtopenic purpura. Tohoku J. Exp. M. 1940-41, 39: 523-32- Wichmann, S. E. Ein Fall von pro'fuser Spiitblutung bei essentieller Thrombopenie nach einer Emmet-Operation. Acta obst. gyn. scand, 1941, 21: 282. ---- Werlhof's disease; Pathogenesis. Gerigk, H. *Gefasswandschadigung als Blu- tungsursache bei der Werlhofschen Krankheit. 23p. 8? Berl., 1928. Hepp, J. *Ein Beitrag zur Frage der essen- tiellen Thrombopenie [Tubingen] 30p. 8? Marbach a. N., 1932. Reich, J. '"Beitrag zur Frage der Pathogenese der Werlhofschen Krankheit [Berlin] 31p. 23cm. Charlottenb., 1938. Blacher, L. Recherches sur la pathogdnie de la thrombo- penie essentielle de Werlhof. Sang, Par, 1938, 12: 26-43.— Brinnitzer, H. N. Morbus Werlhofii mit allergischer Reaktion auf mutterliches Blut der gleichen Blutgruppe. Zschr. Kinderh, 1931 51: 566-78.—Goia, I. [On homogenetic thrombocyto- penia] Rev. st. med, Bucur, 1925, 14: 999-1024.—Goldman, M. [Origin of Werlhof's disease] Polska gaz. lek, 1926, 5: 764-7.—Culler, F. 1, & Lawrence. J. S. Idiopathic thrombo- penic purpura. Ann. Int. M, 1931, 4: 1535-44.—Kaznelson. P. L'dtat actuel de la question de la thrombopdnie essentielle. Strasbourg mdd, 1926, 84: 287-97.—Koller, B. Zur Kenntnis der essentiellen Thrombopenie. Ausz. Inaugur. Diss. Med. Fak. Univ. Bern, 1933-35, No. 36, 1.—Krjukof, A. La maladie de Werlhof conime thrombopdnie fonctionnelle. Sang, Par, 1935, 9: 363-6.—Landau, A, & Hejman, W. Sur la diathese hdmorragique au cours du purpura hdmorragique (maladie de Werlhof) et sur l'inddpendance du nombre des plaquettes sanguines et du temps de saignement dans Involution du pur- pura cutand. Presse mdd, 1934, 42: 174.- I.escliko. E. Neuere Erfahrungen iiber die Pathogenese und 'I hcrapie der thrombopenischen Purpura (Werlhofseho Krankheit) Erg. ges. Med, 1926, 9: 339-46.------A: Wittkowr, E. Die Werlhofsche Blutfleckenkrankheit (thrombopenische Purpura) ein Beitrag zur Pathologic der Blutplattchen und Capillaren und zur Pathogenese der hamorrhagischen Diathese. Zschr. klin. Med, 1925-26, 102: 649-744.—Mauro, E. Thrombo- penv in idiopathic purpura haemorrhagica. Arq. cir. clin. exp', S. Paulo, 1940, 4: 63-71.—Roskam, J. Pathogdnie du sindrome hdmogdiiiqno. Nutrition, Par, 1934, 3: 647-59 — SchifT, K, & Hirschbcrger. C. Weitere Untersuchungen zur Frage des Morbus maculosus Werlhofi; ein bisher unbekannter, Tin ombozvtose herbeifuhrender Stoff, der fettlosliche T-Faktor. Jahrb. Kinderh, 1935-30, 3. F, 96: 293-6, tab.------ Weitere Lntersuchungen zur Frage dos Morbus maculosus Werlhofi; A-Vitamin und Thrombozytose. Ibid, 1936, 3. F, !)7: Sl-5.—Schminckc. Zur Kenntnis der essentiellen Throm- bopenie. Verh. Deut. path. Ges, 1930, 25: 50-2.— Shugurova. M. M. [Pathogenesis of Werlhof's purpura haemorrhagica] Russ. vrach, 1915, 14: 533-40.—Shumilin, I. A. [Patho- genesis of Werlhof's syndrome] Vest, khir, 1939. 58: 166-8 — Torrioli. M. Sulla patogenesi del morbo di Werlhof. Boll. Accad. med. Roma, 1938, 64: 156. Also Policlinico, 1939, 46: sez. med, 285-93.------& Puddu, V. Recent studies on the pathogenesis of Werlhof's disease. J. Am. M. Ass, 1938, 111: 1155.—Wahlberg, J. [Study of essential thrombopenia] Fin. lak. sail, hand, 1933, 75: 69-5-700.—Weil, P. E. L'hdmogdnie; position de la question. Nutrition, Par, 1933, 3: 613-20. ■----- & Isch-Wall, P. La pathogdnie de l'hdmogdnie. Rev. mdd. Par, 1926, 43: 3-23. ---- Werlhof's disease: Pathology. Thonangi, B. R. *Ueber den akuten und chronischen Morbus Werlhof [Berlin] 32p. 8? Charlottenb., 1933. Bruder. Otite moyenne aigue hdmorrhagique au cours de la maladie de Werlhof. J. mdd. Paris, 1909, 2. ser, 21: 46.— Denissowa-Ssuscewskaja, P. Zur Frage iiber die essentielle Thrombopenie und uber den Einfluss des menstruellen Zyklus auf ihren Verlauf. Zbl. Gyn, 1928, 52: 2535-7.—Gerlach, G. Zur Kenntnis des anatomischen Befundes bei Werlhofscher Krankheit. Zbl. allg. Path, 1930, 48: 81-8.—Heinild, S. Observations on essential thrombopenia (Morbus maculosus Werlhofii) Acta med. scand, 1938-39, 98: 38.5-421.—Lewit, S. G, & Malkowa, N. Ueber hamorrhagische Diathesen; forme fruste der Werlhofschen Krankheit. Zschr. khn. Med, 1927, 106: 574-81.—Moiseev, E. A. [A case of nephritic form of Werlhof's disease] Viach. delo, 1923, 6: 502-6.—Nickerson, D. A, & Sunderland, D. A. The histopathology of idiopathic thrombocytopenic purpura hemorrhagica. Am. J. Path, 1937, 13: 463-89, 2 pl.—Ruitinga. P. [Forms of so-called primary purpural Ned. tschr. geneesk, 1929, 73: pt 2, 597(1 -81.— ScharfT, I. Leber eine thromboplastiselie Form des Morbus Werlhof. .Mod. Klin, Berl, 1938, 34: 80-2. ---- Werlhof's disease: Surgery. Altgeld, F. W. *Die Erfolge der Milz. exstirpation bei der essentiellen benignen Throm- bopenie (E. Frank) 9-lp. 8? Berl., 1927. Ehrenberg, C *Uebcr einen Full von essen- tieller Thrombopenie (Frank) und seine Behand- lung durch Milzexstirpation [Kiel] 23p. 8? Berl., 1919. Laporte, M. A. Contribution a l'etude du traitement de la thrombopenie essentielle par la ligature de l'artere spl6nique. 91p. 25}^cm. Bord., 1933. Abrahamsen, H, & Meulengracht, E. [Splenectomy in essential thrombopenia] Hospitalstidende, 1930, 73: [Dansk kir. selsk. forh] 61 -72. Also Ugeskr. laeger, 1930, 92: 181-7.— Bastianelli, P. lTn caso di porpora cronica (trombopenia essenziale) guarito con la allaeeiatura dell'arteria splenica. Arch. ital. chir, 1930-31, 26: 9(1-103. Also Rev. cir, B. Air, 1930, 9: 160-6.—Becart, A. Spienectomie dans un cas de thrombopdnie essentielle, hdmogdnie. C. rend. Congr. fr. mdd. (1927) 1928-29, 19. Congr, 377-81.—Beer, E. Essential thrombocytopenic purpura; purpura hemorrhagica and its treatment by splenectomy. Ann. Surg, 1926, 84: 549-60.— Bertrand-Fontaine, F, & Parlier, R. La spldnectomie dans l'hdmogdnie. Bull. gdn. thdr, 1934, 185: 370-80.—Bloomfield, A. L. A case of idiopathic thrombopenic purpura hemorrhagica with microsplenia, and failure to improve after splenectomv. Internat. Clin, 1931, 41. ser, 3: 179-83, 2 ch. Also in Barker Festschrift, 1932, 179-83.—Borisov, M. B. [Splenectomy in essential thrombopenia] Kazan, med. J, 1939, 35: No. 2-3, 105. —-Bourdc, Y, & Zucarelli, J. Purpura hdmorragique rdcidivant chronique; spldnectomie; gudrison. Bull. Soc. nat. chn. Par, 1927, 53: 1066-71.—Capella, F. Trombosi porto- radicolare dopo splenectomia per Morbo di Werlhof. Boll. Soc. med. chir, Pavia, 1936, 50: 313-28.—Cori, G. Zur Klinik und Therapie (Splenektomie) dir essentiellen Thrombopenie. Zschr. klin. Med, 1922, 94: 356-69.—Currado, C. Splen- ectomia per morbo di Werlhof in un lattante; regressione della sindrome emorragica. Pediatria (Riv.) 1930, 44: 152-8.— Donati, A, & Bayma, F. A purpura hemorragiea esseneial e seu tratamento cirurgico (nota prdvia) Ann. paulist. med. cir, 1928, 19: 93-106.—Duperie, R., Loubat, E, & Dubarry, J. Purpura hdmogdnique de Werlhof grave; spldnectomie suivie de pyopneumothorax sous-phrdnique et de fistule gastro- paridtale. J. mdd. Bordeaux, 1937, 114: 382-8.—Duval, P. Rdsultats dloignds de la'spldnectomie dans un cas de purpura hdmorragique redicivant chronique. Bull. Soc. nat. chir. Par, 1929, 55: 025.—Fagge, H. Essential thrombocytopenia with delayed response to splenectomy. Guy's Hosp. Rep, Lond, 1934, 84: 72-0.—Fcttich, G. [Excision of spleen in the treatment of Werlhof's disease] Orv. hetil, 1930, 74: 115-7.—■ Geggie, C. G. Essential thrombocytopenic purpura haemor- rhagica fa report of 6 operative cases) Canad. M. Ass. J, 193(i, 35: 651-4.—Gentile, G. I risultati della splenectomia nei morbo di Werlhof. Baglivi, 1938, 4: 203-8.3.—GilHn, H. Z. Problems associated with the treatment of essential thrombo- cytopenic purpura: notes of 44 cases in wliich splenectomy was performed. Tr. Ass. Am. Physicians, 1932, 47: 218-30.— Goidsenhoven, F. van [Treatment of essential thrombopenia by ligation of splenic artery] Ned. mschr. geneesk, 1929, 16: 173-242. Also Rev. beige sc. mdd, 1929, 1: 97-143. Also Rev. mdd, Louvain, 1929, 152-6.—Giirog, D. Ueber die essentielle Thrombopenie; ein experimenteller Beitrag zur Wirkung der Entmilzung auf das Knochenmark und die Zahl der Blutplattchen. Virchows Arch, 1932, 284: 917-28.— Gosset, Chevallier, P, & Gutmann, R. A. Grande hdmogdnie (purpura hdmorragique) chronique cryptogdndtique gudrie par la spldnectomie. Bull. Soc. mdd. hop. Paris, 1928, 3. ser, 52: 364-8.—Gran, B. Di un caso di morbo di Werlhof guarito con splenectomia. Pediatria (Riv.) 1932, 40: 592-604.— Grcgoire, R. Les rdsultats du traitement chirurgical dans l'hdmogdnie. Nutrition, Par, 1933, 3: 711-6.—Grevillius, A. [Splenectomy in essential thrombopenia] Hygiea, Stockh, 1931, 93: 657-01.—Grove, L, & Monfort, J. M. Thrombo- penic purpura (Werlhof's disease) Tr. South. Surg. Ass, 1932, 44: 192.—Haselhorst, G. Milzexstirpation wegen schwerer genitaler Blutungen bei einem Falle von essentieller Thrombo- cytopenic. Zbl. Gyn, 1929, 53: 3033-6. -Hatzieganu, I, & Iacobovici, I. Deux cas d'hdmogdnie gudris par la spldnectomie. C. rend. Congr. fr. mdd. (1927) 1928-29, 19. Congr, 348-50 — Hefter, L. I. [Case of splenectomv in Werlhof's disease] Klin. med. Moskva, 1929, 7: 1009-12.—Hinschberger, G, Muller, P., & Have, P. Un cas de maladie de Werlhof traitd par la spldn- ectomie, examen de la rate. Strasbourg mdd, 1934, 94: 187- 90.—Klumov, E. V. [Splenectomy in Werlhof's disci sei Sovet. klin, 1932, 18: 141-7.—Kogen, B. E, & Genkin, 1. I. [Case of essential thrombopenia cured bv operation; splenectomy] Vrach. delo, 1929, 12: 1143-7.—Kosdoba, A. S. Zui Behand- I lung der essentiellen Thrombopenie. Arch. klin. Chir., 1931, HEMORRHAGIC DIATHESIS 561 HEMORRHAGIC DIATHESIS 166: 794-806. Also Vest, khir, 1933, 31: 110-8.—Kuru, M. Zur Kenntnis der essentiellen Thrombopenie. Jap. J. M. Sc, Tokyo, 1930-32, 2: Surg, 359-82.—Kyers, B. Three cases of essential purpura haemorrhagica: splenectomy. Proc. It. Soc. M, Lond., 1933, 26: 357.—Lafargue. Spldnectomie pour maladie de Werlhoff; rdsultat au bout de 18 mois. Bordeaux chir, 1933, 4: 150-2.—Lanesen, V. [Splenectomy in treatment of essential thrombopenia] Hospitalstidende, 1933, 76: [med. selsk. fyens stifts forh.] 14-9.—Le Marquand, H. S. Idiopathic purpura haemorrhagica; 2 acute and one chronic case success- fully treated by splenectomy. Roy. Berkshire Hosp. Rep, 1933, 121-37.—Levrat, M, & Clavel, C. Spienectomie pour hdmorragies graves au cours d'une hdmogdnie. Lyon mdd, 1934, 154: 70-78.—Lewisohn, R. Post-operative shock follow- ing splenectomy for chronic thrombocytopenic purpura. Ann. Surg, 1932, 96: 447.—Mallet-Guy, P., & Croizat, P. Hdmo- gdnie chez une fillette de 11 ans; spldnectomie aprds dchec de la radiothdrapie. Lyon chir, 1937, 34: 495-8.—Myers, B. Splenectomy for essential thrombocytopenic purpura liEemor- rhagica in a girl aged 10 years. Proc. R. Soc. M, Lond, 1925-26, 19: Sect. Clin, 31-4. ----— Splenectomy for essential thrombocytopenic purpura hemorrhagica. Ibid, 1926-27, 20: Sect. Stud. Dis. Child, 30. ------ Case of essential thrombocytopenic purpura haemorrhagica a year after splenectomy. Ibid, Sect. Chn, 33. ■—---- Two cases of essential thrombocytopenic purpura hremorrhagica 2 years after splenectomy. Ibid, 1927-28, 21: Sect. Chn, 68-70. ----- Splenectomy for essential purpura haemorrhagica (essential thrombocytopenic purpura haemorrhagica) S. Barth. Hosp. J, 1933, 41:44-6. —----Maingot, R, & Gordon, A. K. Three cases of splenectomy for essential thrombo- cytopenic purpura haemorrhagica. Proc. R. Soc. M, Lond, 1925-26, 19: Sect. Chn, 37-40.—Nobecourt, P, Liege, R, & Grodnitsky. Hdmogdnie; dpistaxis rebelles k toute thdrapeuti- que chez une fille de 11}^ ans; spldnectomie; arret immediat des hdmorragies. BuU. Soc pediat. Paris, 1932, 30: 186-94.— Paolucci, R. Morbo di Werlhof; emogenia. In his Lezioni clin. chir, Bologna, 1934, 225-36. Also 2. ed, Roma, 1939, 225- 36.—Perry, C. L, & McCIamroch, J. M. Idiopathic thrombo- cytopenic purpura hemorrhagica treated by splenectomy; report of a case. J. Florida M. Ass, 1936-37, 23: 184 — Pinkerton, C. C. Splenectomy as a curative measure in essential thrombocytopenic purpura. Ohio M. J, 1928, 24: 788-91.—Prerovsky, K. [Splenectomy in chronic essential haemorrhagic thrombopenic purpura] Bratisl. lek. listy, 1927-28, 7: 366-73.—Proctor, R. Chronic thrombocytopenic purpura hemorrhagica; splenectomy. J. Am. M. Ass, 1931, 96: 109.—Quenu, J, & Stoianovitch, S. M. Purpura hdmor- ragique chronique rdcidivant; spienectomie; bon rdsultat immediat, mort au bout de 11 mois par reprise des hemorragies. BuU. Soc. nat. chir. Par, 1929, 55: 111-21—Reilingh, W. [A case of splenectomy in essential thrombopenia] Ned. tschr. geneesk, 1926, 70: 441-5.—Rhame, J. S. Splenectomy in purpura hemorrhagica (essential thrombocytopenia) J. S. Carolina M. Ass, 1928, 24: 247-52.—Ryden, A. Beitrag zur Frage der essentieUen Thrombopenie und ihrer Behandlung. Acta chir. scand, 1934, 74: 88-124.—Sakai, Y. Ueber einen Fall von durch Splenektomie ausgeheilter Werlhofscher Krank- heit. Okayama igakkai zasshi, 1930, 42: 137-9.—Schaak, V. A. [Removal of the spleen in thrombopenia essentialis] Vest. khir, 1927, 9: No. 25, 50-60. Also Deut. Zschr. Chir, 1927, 203:-204: 62-70.—Schiassi, F. La splenectomia nei morbo maculoso di Werlhof. Arch, pat, Bologna, 1928, 7: 73-94.— Schutze. Morbus maculosus Werlhofii. ln Beitr. Kriegsheilk. Deut. Ver. Rot. Kreuz, Lpz, 1908, 198.—Simonetti Cuizza, R. Morbo di Werlhof; splenectomia. Pediat. med. prat. Tor, 1938, 13: 33; 237.—Szyftnan, L., & Kocen, M. [Remote sequels of splenectomy in 6 cases of essential thrombopenia] Polska gaz. lek, 1933, 12: 660.—Troupiansky, M. S. [Splenectomy in Werlhof's disease] Khirurgia, Moskva, 1939, No. 9, 90-7.— Usseglio, G, & Pepino, L. Sui risultati loani deUa sple- nectomia nella malattia di Werlhof. Minerva med. Tor, 1934, 25: 250-4.—Valdez, J. M., & Girardet, O. E. Purpura cronica primitiva en la infancia; esplenectomia. Arch, argent, pediat, 1931, 2: 293-313.—Wahlqvist, S. Der unmittelbare Etfekt der Splenektomie auf das Blutbild bei essentieller Thrombo- penie. Acta med. scand, 1936, 90: 81-133.—Weil, P. E. Un cas d'hdmogdnie gudrie pendant pres de 2 ans par la spld- nectomie; rdcidive grave; gudrison par la suppression des rdgles Bull. Soc. mdd. hop. Paris, 1931, 3. ser, 47: 229-33.—Woenck- haus, E. Beitrag zur Milzexstirpation bei der essentiellen Thrombopenie. Zschr. klin. Med, 1928, 109: 279-84.— Zuidema [Case of Werlhof's disease; relapse foUowing excision of the spleen] Geneesk. tschr. Ned. Indie, 1941, 81: 97. --- Werlhof's disease: Treatment. Kunze, G. *Essentielle Thrombopenie und ihre Therapie [Berlin] 15p. 21cm. Wiirzb., 1938. Leutz, H. *Ein Fall von essentieller Thrombo- penie und seine Behandlung [Heidelberg] 35p. 21cm. Germersheim a. Rh. [1937] Matutt, H. *Ueber die Therapie der essen- tiellen Thrombopenie [Leipzig] 23p. 8? Zeu- lenroda, 1934. 227475—VOL. 7, 4th SERIES----36 Amuchastegui, T. R. La enfermedad de Werlhof y el calomel. Sem. mdd, B. Air, 1907, 14: 903.—Aresu, M. Presupposti patogenetici e orientamenti terapeutici in tema di trombopenia essenziale. Athena, Roma, 1936, 5: 339-42.— Bassen, F. A. Failure of irradiation of the spleen with roentgen rays in the treatment of essential thrombocytopenic purpura J. Mount Sinai Hosp. N. York, 1937-38, 4: 461-3—Bertrand- Fontaine, T. L'hdmogdnie et son traitement. J. mdd. chir. Par 1937, 108: 57-64.—Briihl, H. Beitrage zum Krankheits- bild und zur Behandlung des Morbus maculosus Werlhofi. Zschr. Kinderh, 1932-33, 54: 159-95.—Goia, I. Un cas d hemogdme amdliord par la radiothdrapie. Bull. Soc. mdd. nop- Paris, 1926, 3. ser, 555-8.—Gram, H. C. [A cured case of Werlhof's disease after recurrent protein shock, with remarks on special blood examination and treatment] Hospitalstidende, 1922 65: 649-62.—Grosglik, A. Zur Rontgenbehandlung der Werlhofschen Krankheit. Strahlentherapie, 1926, 22: 721-5.— Hildebrandt, A. Zur Behandlung starker Genitalblutungen bei essentieller Thrombopenie. Med. Welt, 1937, 11: 1103-5.— Holbpll, S. A. [Case of essential thrombopenia treated with liver extract] Hospitalstidende, 1929, 72: 841-7.—Imerman, C. P, & Imerman, S. W. Thrombocytopenic purpura hemor- rhagica; treatment with- massive doses of moccasin snake venom. California West. M, 1938, 48: 335-7.—Jacobson, E. Versuch einer Behandlung des Morbus maculosus Werlhofii mit Phenylhydrazinum hydrochloricum. Arch. exp. Path, Berl, 1932, 166: 603. ------• Weitere Erfahrungen mit Phenyl- hydrazinum hydrochloricum beim Morbus Werlhof. Med. Klin, Berl, 1933, 29: 712. ------ Zur Behandlung des Morbus Werlhof mit Phenylhydrazin. Schweiz. med. Wschr, 1938, 68: 991.—Jegoroff, B, & Serdukoff, G. Sur le traitement du syndrome de Werlhof par le sdroplacentol (sdrum du cordon ombilical) Gyndcologie, Par, 1934, 33: 434-46.—Le Goff. Gudrison apparente d'un cas d'hdmogdnie par radiothdrapie. BuU. Soc. radiol. mdd. France, 1934, 22: 315-9.—Levy, M, & Gaily, L. Le traitement de l'hdmogdnie essentielle, ou thrombo- cytopdnie essentieUe, par la radiothdrapie spldnique. Arch. mal. app. digest. Par, 1939, 29: 865-903. Also Presse mdd, 1939, 47: 1420-2.—Liamin, N. E. [Blood transfusion in Werl- hof's disease] KUn. med, Moskva, 1940, 18: No. 11, 82-8.— Lorenz, E. Zur Vitaminbehandlung der Werlhofschen Krank- heit. Wien. klin. Wschr, 1936, 49: 1195-7—Meda, G. Roentgenterapia nei morbo di Werlhof. Radiol, med, Milano, 1926, 13: 563-78.—Merklen, P, & Wolf, M. Traitement de l'hdmogdnie. Bull. Soe. mdd. hop. Paris, 1926, 3. ser, 572-8.— Mettier, S. R., Stone, R. S, & Purviance, K. The effect of Roentgen ray irradiation on platelet production in patients with essential thrombocytopenic purpura haemorrhagica. Am. J. Sc, 1936, 191: 794-807. Also repr.—Neumann, H. O. Vitamin C-Therapie bei profusen Genitalblutungen infolge essentieUer Thrombopenie. Khn. Wschr, 1936, 15: 368-71—Patushin- skaia, F. P. [CUnical treatment of essential thrombopenia (Werlhof's disease)] Vrach. delo, 1938, 20: 207-10.—Rabino- witz, H. M. A study of the role of amino acids in clot retrac- tion; the effect of methionine in restoring normal clot retraction and control of bleeding in essential thrombocytopenic purpura. Am. J. Surg, 1941, 51: 366-78.—Roth, O. Therapie des Morbus maculosus Werlhofi; gibt es zurzeit eine aussichtsreiche Therapie des Morbus maculosus Werlhofi? sind Pferdeserumin- jektionen zu empfehlen? Schweiz. med. Wschr, 1935, 65: 1011.—Rudisill, H, jr. The successful treatment of essential thrombopenia with hemorrhage by roentgen rays. J. Am. M. Ass, 1936, 107: 2119.—Sailerova, J. [Treatment of essential thrombopenia] Cas. ldk. desk, 1935, 74: 820.— Schaefer, W. Zur Therapie der essentiellen Thrombopenie. Zbl. Gyn, 1932, 56: 1158-65.—Schiff, E. Zur Therapie der essentiellen Throm- bopenie im Kindesalter (Morbus mac. Werlhofii) Klin. Wschr, 1935, 14: 1504. ------ & Hirschberger, C. Weitere Unter- suchungen zur Frage des Morbus maculosus Werlhofi; Einfluss der Vitamine A, Bi, B2, C, D und des Eigelbs auf die Zahl der Thrombozyten bei gesunden Kindern. Jahrb. Kinderh, 1935- 36, 3. F, 96: 181-90, ch. ------ Einfluss der Vitamine C, A, B2 und des Eigelbs auf die Zahl der Thrombozyten und die Blutungszeit beim Morbus maculosus Werlhofi. Ibid, 191-6, ch.—Sooy, J. W, & Moise, T. S. Treatment of idiopathic purpura hemorrhagica by exposure to mercury vapor quartz lamp; preliminary report. J. Am. M. Ass, 1926, 87: 94.— Svastits, P. Beitrage zur Therapie der Werlhof-Krankheit. Mschr. Kinderh, 1937, 68: 207-11.—Tolstoi, E. Purpura hemorrhagica (essential thrombocytopenia) treatment by the mercury vapor lamp. J. Am. M. Ass, 1927, 89: 370-2.— Trossarelli, L. L'iniezione endovenosa di rosso Congo nei morbo di Werlhof. Fisiol. & med, Roma, 1933, 4: 277-83. Also Gazz. med. ital, 1936, 45: 137-10.—Weil, P. E. Traite- ment de l'hdmogdnie. Nutrition, Par, 1933, 3: 703-10. Also Progr. mdd. Par, 1939, 782.—Wolff, S. Beitrag zur Therapie der Werlhofschen Krankheit. Zschr. Kinderh, 1931-32, 52: 156-60. ---- in animals. See also Hematuria; Hemoglobinuria; Hemo- philia; Purpura cyprinorum. Bleton, R. *Le purpura hemorragique essentiel du chien. 65p. 25/2cm. Lyon, 1934. Boisson de Chazournes, L. *Le pouvoir hemorragipare chez le lapin du serum et dea HEMORRHAGIC DIATHESIS 562 HEMORRHAGIC DIATHESIS tissus humains normaux et pathologiques. 265p. 8? Lyon, 1937. Bolnat, (i. *Le purpura hdmorragique des femelles de l'espece bovine [Alfort] 44p. 8? Par., 1925. Pezet, M. A. M. *Le purpura hdmorragique essentiel du chien [Alfort] 71p. 8? Cavaillon, 1926. Schurter, A. *Beitrag zur Pathologie des Morbus maculosus equorum. 70p. 8? Ziir., 1909. Xiroudakis, N. I. *Purpura hemorragique du chien [Alfort] 42p. 8? Hennebont, 1926. Aehle. Die Behandlung der Blutfleckenkrankheit der Pferde mit Yatren purum. Zschr. Vcteriniirk, 1937, 49: 252-67.— Alechinsky, A. Study of haemorrhagic phenomena. Vet. BuU, Lond, 1941, 11: 876 (Abstr.)— Aimquist, H. J, & Stokstad, E. L. R. Factors influencing the incidence of dietarv hemor- rhagic disease in chicks. J. Nutrit, 1936, 12: 329-35.— Bogner, G. [Fibrolysin and streptococcus serum treatment of purpura] AUatorv. lap, 1912, 35: 378.-Bolnat, G. Note sur un cas de purpura hdmorragique des betes bovines. Rec. mdd. vdt, 1921. 97: 12-4.—Bouchet. Purpura hdmorragique du chien. Bull. Soc. centr. mdd. vdt, 1927, 80: 361.—Bouchet, pere, & Bouchet. fils. Sur les purpuras. Ibid, 130-5.— Breton, F. Sur un cas probable de purpura hdmorragique chez le cheval. Ibid, 1914-15, 91: 187-90.—Brimhall, S. D, & Hardenbergh, J. G. A case of purpura hemorrhagica with special reference to the use of epinephrin. J. Am. Vet. M. Ass, 1921-22, 59: 762-6.—Brown, F. F. Purpura hemor- rhagica. North Am. Vet, 1922, 3: 618; 636.—Davenport, C. Purpuric conditions in animals. Proc. R. Soc. M, Lond, 1936- 37, 30: 723-5.—Davies, J. J., & Chesney, R. W. L. A condition resembling purpura haemorrhagica, in a dog. Vet. Rec, Lond, 1934, 14: 1.'I26.—Dervillez, A. Purpura hdmorra'dque du chien. Rec. mod. vdt, 1929, 105: 12-4.—Duran-Reynals, F, & iluinias, R. M. A hemorrhagic disease occurring in chicks inoeulnted with the Rous and Fuginami viruses, with a section on histopathological findings. Yale J. Biol, 1940-41 13: 77-98, 3 pl.—Eggink, C. A. [Morbus maculosus] Tschr. diergenecsk, 1922, 49: 142.—Fischer. K. E. Ein Fall von Mor- bus Werlhofi beim Pferd. Munch, tieunztl. Wschr. 1931, 82: 225-31.—Geiger, W. Morbus maculosus beim Schwein. Deut. tierarztl. Wsehr, 1929, 37: 513-5.—Gerspach. Morbus maculosus beim Rinde. Mitt. Verein.badisch. Tieriirzte, 1912, 12: 17.—Gray, H. Purpura haemorrhagica in cat. Vet. Rec, Lond, 1927, 7: 708.—Heller. V. Einige FaUe von Blutflecken- krankheit beim Sehwein. Wien. tierarztl. Mschr, 1929, 16: 81-4.—HuIum Nartman [Successful treatment of purpura in domestic animals] Askeri vet. mecmuasi, 1939, 16: 127-36.— Jauffret. Purpura du chien avec troubles nerveux k type hallucinatoire. Rec. mdd. vdt, 1934, 110: 606-9.—Kraemer. Kalzine bei Morbus maculosus. Berl. tierarztl. Wschr, 1916, 32: 41.—Kuhn, K. Petechialfieber beim Hunde. Ibid, 1924, 40: 285.—Laas, A. Beitrag zur Behandlung des Morbus maculosus equorum mit Calcium und Jod. Arch. wiss. prakt Tierh, 1933-34, 67: 335-9.—Laszlo, F, & Miklos. R. [Hemor- rhagic diathesis of cattle as a stable enzootic] AUatorv. lap, 1939, 62: 1-5.—Lissot, G. Purpura hdmorragique chez la vache. Rec. mdd. vdt. Par, 1917, 93: 357-60.------Sur un nouveau cas de purpura hdmorragique chez la vache. Ibid, 1920, 96: 34-8.—McCunn, J. The intravenous injection of a solution of formaldehyde in purpura haemorrhagica in horses. Vet. BuU, Wash, 1923,12:21. ------ Purpura hajmorrhagica in horses. Vet. J, Lond, 1926, 82: 370.—Mahon, F. C. Obser- vations on purpura haemorrhagica in the horse with addenda of allied affections. Vet. J, Lond, 1916, 72: 22-4.—Narsaya, V. R. A case of purpura haemorrhagica in a horse. Ind. Vet.' J, 1940, 16: 336.—Nieder. Contribution k l'etude du purpura hdmorrhagique chez les animaux: le purpura essentiel du chien Bull. Soc. centr. mdd. vdt, 1922, 75: 225-30.—Noell. Un cas de purpura hdmorragique du chien. Rec. mdd. vdt, 1929, 105: 462.—Pfeiler, W. Zur Yatren-Gelatine-Therapie beim Morbus maculosus der Pferde. Munch, tierarztl. Wschr, 1924, 75: 57-60.------• & Lttders. M. Ueber einen weiteren Fall von Heuung schwerster Blutfleckenkrankheit mit Hamodiathesan und Cejodyl-cacodylicum. Ibid, 1930, 81: 129-31—Purpura hemorrhagica. Cornell Vet, 1935, 25: 59-61.—Rabagliati, D S. Purpura haemorrhagica in the ox. J. Comp. Path Ther Edinb, 1925, 38: 27-37. Also Proc. R. Soc. M, Lond, 1936- 37, 30: 720-9.—Bernhardt. Morbus maculosus des Rindes Mhefte prakt. Tierh, 1909, 21: 221-38.—Schmidt, J. Ein Beitrag zum Wesen des Morbus maculosus unserer Haustiere- Untersuchungen eines Krankheitsfalles beim Schwein Zschr' Infektkr. Haustiere, 1911, 12: 161-76, 4 pl. ------ Die spezifische Therapie des Morbus maculosus des Pferdes Arch wiss. prakt. Tierh, 1918, 14: Suppl, 280-309. —---- & Meyer. C Die Gelatine-Therapie des Peteelnalfiebers des Pferdes. Deut. tierarztl Wschr, 1914, 22: 457-9.—Schriever Heilung von Morbus maculosus nach Neosalvarsaiiinjektion' Berl. tierarztl. Wschr, 1918, 34: 393.—Senseman, B. F. Horse typhus; morbus maculosus (purpura hemorrhagica) J Am \et. M. Ass, 1919, 55: 385-90.—Sobolev, A. S. [Morbus maculosus equorum; treatment] Sovet. vet, 1939, 16: No 3 99.—Steel, E. B. Observations on the treatment' of purpura hemorrhagica. J. Am. Vet. M. Ass, 1922-23, 62: 766-8 — Stetter, K. Morbus maculosus bei Pferd und Hund und seine Behandlung. Munch, tierarztl. Wsehr, 1928, 79: 441-4 — Strode, C. W. Purpura hemorrhagica at an Army remount Am. J. Vet. M, 1918, 13: 446-8. Taskin. Un cas de purpura hdmorragique essentiel du chien. Bull. Soc. centr. mdd. vdt 1927, 80: 362.—Ukhanov, A. V. [Treatment of morbus macu- losus in horses with camphor serum] Sovet. vet, 1940, 17- No. 4, 81.—Moussu, R. Observations et recherches sur le purpura hdmorragique essentiel du chien. Rec. mdd. vdt 1923, 99: 441-50.—Vogt. Morbus maculosus beim Kalb' Berl. tierarztl. Wschr, 1925, 41: 650. — Weygold. Die Blut- fleckenkrankheit des Schweines. Zschr. FrVisch Milchhve 1931-32, 42: 439.—Wirth, D. Die hamorrhaLdschcn Diathesen der Haustiere (unter besonderer Beriicksichtigung jener dea Hundes) Wien. tierarztl. Mschr, 1925, 12: 593-609. ----- Thrombopenische Purpura beim Hund. Ibid, 19,'Si;, 23: :r,:i . 9.—Wolf, E. Kasuistischcr Beitrag zur Frage des I'eterliial- fiebers beim Hund. Berl. tierarztl. Wschr, 1925. II: SOS Wooldridge. Purpura haemorrhagica. Vet. Rec, Lond, 1917 29: 351-7.—Wyssmann, E. Kommt die Blutfleckenkrankheit auch bei Ziegen vor? Schweiz. Arch. Tierh, 1939, 81: 212-5. ---- in pregnancy, and puerperium. Berry, P. R. *Zur Kenntnis der Massen- blutungen ins Gehirn bei Thrombopenie; recidi- vierende essentielle Thrombopenie, symptoma- tische Thrombopenie bei Tuberkulose. 36p 22>/2cm. Zur., 1939. Alt, H. L., Carroll, H. B, & Doherty, C. C. Thrombopenic purpura associated with catarrhal jaundice; report of a case during pregnancy. Q. BuU. Northwest. Univ. M. School, 1940, 14: 183-6.—Astrinsky, S. |Course of pregnancy and delivery in case of Werlhof's disease] Mosk. med. J, 1927, 7: No. 6, 55-65.—Batizfalvy, J. Die gynakologische und geburtshilfliche Bedeutung der thrombopenischen Purpura. Zschr. Geburtsh Clvn, 1939, 119: 65-95.—Bernstein, P., Newman, A. B, & Ilitzig, W. H. The problem of idiopathic purpura hemor- rhagica in pregnancy and the neonatal period. Am. J. Obst, 1939, 38: 323-7.—Bolcy, H. B. Purpura hemorrhagica com- plicating puerperium. Ibid, 1930, 20: 252.—Breda. L. Schwan- gerschaftsunterbrechung wegen Morbus Werlhofii in gravi- ditate; ein Beitrag zu dessen Pathogenese. Zbl. Gyn, 1930, 54: 158-63.—Delanoe, E. De l'emploi systdmatique de la mdthode de Fauchier dans le traitement des purpuras hdmorragipares par insuffisance des glandes k sdcrdtions internes au cours de la grossesse, de 1'aUaitement et de la mdnopause. MarseiUe mdd, 1930, 67: 404-8. — Purpura hdmor- ragique grave au cours de la gestation chez une femme marocaine, gudri par un abces de fixation. Ibid, 745-52.—DeSaussure, H. W, & Townsend, E. W. Purpura hemorrhagica in preg- nancy. Am. J. Obst, 1935, 29: 597-9.—Filippone, A. Un caso di morbo di Werlhof al secondo mese di gravidanza. Clin. ostet, 1928, 30: 484-97.—Fornero, A. Osservazione clinica intorno ad un caso di diatesi emorragica in gravidanza. Riv. ital. gin, 1924-25, 3: 323-31.—Guggisberg, H. Die gynako- logische und geburtshUfliche Bedeutung der essentieUen throm- bopenischen Purpura. Helvet. med. acta, 1936, 3: 375-97 — Hammerschlag. EssentieUe Thrombopenie (Morbus maculosus Werlhofii) in der Graviditas Med. Welt, 1929, 3: 447-9 — Hottenstein. H. W, & Klingman, W. O. Purpura hemor- rhagica complicating pregnancy; report of a case. Am. J. Obst, 1927, 13: 375-8.—Israel, S.L, & Winson.S.G. Purpu- ra hemorrhagica complicating pregnancy. Ibid, 1941, 42: 157- 9- Khitrov, A. [Purpura haemorrhagica in pregnancy] Prakt. vrach, 1912, 11: 292-5.—Krell, S. Blood dyscrasia complicat- ing pregnancy and puerperium, with report of 2 cases. Am. J. Obst, 1927, 13: 108-12.—Liebling, P. Purpura hemorrhagica complicating pregnancy; report of a case in which both mother and child were affected and recovered. Ibid, 1926, 11: 847- 50- Luka§. J. [Rare combination of pregnancy with essential thrombopenia] Bratisl. lek. listy, 1935, 15: 328-34.—Malkova, M. N. [Prognosis in essential thrombopenia in pregnancy Mosk med. J, 1920, 6: No. 12, 20-3—McGoogan, L. S. Secondary purpura hemorrhagica complicating pregnancy. Am. J. Obst, 1935, 29: 576-9.—Palombelli, M. Un caso di trombopenia essenziale in gravidanza a decorso maligno. Riv. osp, 1932, 22: 303-77.—Posner, A. C. Purpura hemor- 'hagica complicating the puerperium. Am. J. Obst, 1937, 34: 155-8. Revoltella, G. Su due casi di porpora emorragica in gravidanza. Rinasc. med, 1929, 6: 405.—Rochat, R. L. A propos de diathdse hdmorragiparc en gyndcologie. Rev. mdd. Suisse rom, 1928, 48: 396-403.—Rossi, D. Porpora emorragica in gravidanza. Arch, ostet. gin, 1929, 2. ser, 16: 191-202.— Siegler, S. L. Purpura hemorrhagica compUcating pregnancy. Med. Rec, N. Y, 1934, 139: 189.—Tesauro, G. Porpora e gravidanza. Arch, ostet. gin , 1932, 2. ser, 19: 371.—Vignali, A. Emogenia e gravidanza (alcuni rilievi cUniei ed ematologici intorno a due casi di porpora a tipo emogenico) Rass. ostet., 1927, 36: 259; 344; 398. HEMORRHOID. See also Anus subheadings (Diseases: Fissure; Fistula, &c) HEMORRHOID 563 HEMORRHOID Bensatjde, R., & Bensaude, A. Les hemor- roides et leur traitement. 163p. 25cm. Par., 1939. Bensaude, R., & Ottry, P. Les hemorroides et leur traitement. 16? Par. [1930] Hamorrhoiden. p.647-86. 12? [Berl., 1780] Cutting from Krunitz. dkon. techn. Encykl, Berl, 1780, 20: Th. Morley, A. S. Haemorrhoids; their aetiology, prophylaxis and treatment by means of injections. 4. impr. 122p. 8? Lond., 1929. Palant, M. Hemorroides. 114p. 26}4cm. B. Air., 1938. Prtjitt, M. C. Hemorrhoids. 170p. 25}^cm. S. Louis, 1938. Back, I. Some remarks on piles. Med. Prcs & Circ, Lond, 1936, 193: 202-5.—Doerfler, H. Die Haemorrhoiden. Miinch. med. Wschr, 1936, 83: 2003-6. Also in his Fur d. Praxis, Miinch, 1938, 2: 195-206.—Fansler, W. A. Hemor- rhoids; their general consideration. J. Lancet, 1929, 49: 289- 91.—Fischer, A. W. Diagnose und Therapie bei Hiimor- rhoidalbeschwerden. Med. KUn, Berl, 1935, 31: 69.— Frankman, W. The diagnosis and treatment of hemorrhoids and their complications. Med. Rec, N. Y, 1936, 144: 218. Also repr.—Gutierrez Muro, F. Hemorroides. Med. ibera, 1931, 15: 333-45.—K. Hamorrhoiden. Mitt. Biochem, 1938, 45: 94-6.—Krause, G. L. Hemorrhoids. Week. BuU. S. Louis M. Soc, 1938-39, 33: 349-53.—Laufman, H. Hemor- rhoids. Hygeia, Chic, 1940, 18: 410. Also repr.—Lovelock- Jones, W. D. Haemorrhoids. Nurs. Times, Lond, 1941, 37: 838-40.—McKittrick, L. S. Hemorrhoids. Common Health, Bost, 1934, 21: 33-5.—Montague, J. F. Important facts about hemorrhoids. In his Troubles [etc.] 2. ed, N. Y, 1939, 17-31.—Morgan, C. N. Haemorrhoids. Practitioner, Lond, 1936, 136: 172-85. Also Brit. M. J, 1939, 1: 459-61.— Pennington, J. R. Hemorrhoids. J. Am. M. Ass, 1926, 87: 2064-71.—Perry, C. C. The diagnosis and treatment of diseases of the anus, rectum and colon; hemorrhoids. Med. World, 1938, 56: 713-7.—Rainey, W.R. Hemorrhoids. South. M. J, 1940,33:1335-42.—Ramond, L. Hemorroides. J. mdd. chir. Par, 1927, 98: 814^40.—Rosser, C. Hemorrhoids. J. Lancet, 933, 53: 584-9.—Runyeon, F. G. Hemorrhoids. In Cyclop. Med. (Piersol-Bortz) Phila, 1940, 13: 456-66, 2 pl.—Smith, D, & Sipman, H. Hemorrhoids. In Dis. Digest. System (Portis, S. A.) Phila, 1941, 930-4.—Strauss, H. Hamor- rhoiden und Hamorrhoidalkrankheit. Med. Welt, 1927, 1: 126-8.—Zorraquin, G. Hemorroides. Congr. argent, cir, 1930, 561-72. --- Bleeding. Doumer, E. Flux hdmorroidaires ddpldtifs dans l'hyper- tension artdrieUe. Ann. dlectrob, LiUe, 1909, 12: 577.— Drueck, C. J. Bleeding piles. West. M. Times, 1933, 52: 139.—Pitanga Santos, R. Os preconceitos em pathologia ano- rectal: as hemorrhagias hemorrhoidarias. Fol. med, Rio, 1928, 9: 116-20.—Sklodowski, J, & Dobryszycki, S. [Case of grave anemia caused by hemorrhoidal hemorrhages of long duration] Warsz. czas. lek, 1936, 13: 426.—Thewlis, M. W. Severe anemia due to bleeding from hemorrhoids. Med. Rev. of Rev, 1927, 33: 77. --- Complication. Blond, K.,. & Hoff, H. Das Hamorrhoidal- leiden; seine Kompilationen und deren Be- handlung. 121p. 8? Lpz., 1936. Barker, L. F. Profound secondary anemia with spleno- megaly (Banti's syndrome) in a patient who has had bleeding internal hemorrhoids for a year, and a history suggestive of gastric ulcer for 15 years and who now has achylia gastrica and a filUng defect at the pylorus, which has caused suspicion of the existence of cancer of the stomach; discussion of diag- nosis and therapeutical management. Med. Clin. N. America, 1930, 14: 47-55.—Becker. Behandlung von hochsitzenden hamorrhoidalen Schleimhautrissen. Fortsch. Ther, 1938, 14: 615.—McCowan, D. C. The cause and frequency of ulcera- tions and of recurrences of hemorrhoids. Tr. Am. Coll. Proct., 1932, 9: 165-9. Also Tr. Am. Proct. Soc, 1932, 164-70 — McNamara, T. F. Hemorrhoids, the cause of other conditions of ill-health. Am. Med, 1935, 41: 77-9.—Mesnard, A. Trata- mento da cystite hemorroidaria. Novid. med. pharm, Porto, 1903-4, 9: 141.—Murray, D. H. Report of 6 cases of profound secondary anemia due to internal hemorrhoids and necrosis of the rectum as result of self-treatment. Med. Progr, Louisv, 1910, 26: 31-5.—Oury, P, & Dubois, J. Les compUcations des hdmorroides et, leur traitement. BuU. gdn. thdr, 1937, 188: 10-21. Also in Thdr. mdd. actual. Par. (1937) 1938, 4: 10-21.—Rostock, P. Hamorrhoiden und Analfissuren. Deut. med. Wschr, 1940, 66: 241.—Saphir, J. F. Profound anaemia due to ulcerated internal hemorrhoids (a report of 3 cases) Tr. Am. Proct. Soc, 1929, 29: 35-9.—Wells, H. O. Treatment of complicated hemorrhoids. Tr. Am. Coll. Proct, 1932, 9: 139-53. Also Tr. Am. Proct. Soc, 1932, 138-53. ---- Etiology. Niemeyer, P. Om hamorrojder och for- stoppnmg. 53p. 8? Stockh., 1895. Biancalana, L. Sulla patogenesi deUe emorroidi. Arch. ital. anat. pat, 1931, 2: 1051-76.—Brown, T. O. The connec- tion between prostatic disease and hemorrhoids. J. Am. Coll Proct, 1933-34, 6: 81—Drueck, C. J. Why do we have hemor- rhoids? Indianapolis M. J, 1925, 28: 241-4.—Fleischer, F. Ueber Hamorrhoiden. Zschr. iirztl. Fortbild, 1931, 28: 175-81.—Gutmann, M. J. Zur Vererbung der Haemorrhoiden. Arch. Rassenb, 1925, 17: 321.—Holehan, M. W. The etiology, pathology and rational treatment of hemorrhoids. Mississippi Doctor, 1940-41, 18: 507-11.—Howard, C. E. Some ideas concerning the etiology of hemorrhoids. Tr. Am. Proct. Soc, 1935, 36: 172-7. Also Bull. Off. Pract, 1938-39, 12: 181; 184.—Incidence of hemorrhoids and prostatic enlargement among 15,700 examinees by age, sex, and weight groups. Proc. Life Ext. Exam, 1940, 2: 139-42.—Lynch, J. M, Hurley, V., & Hamilton, G. J. Hemorrhoids: their origin and treatment. Am. J. Digest. Dis, 1936-37, 3: 936-9.—Workmen's compensa- tion acts; hemorrhoids in relation to strain (Missouri) J. Am. M. Ass, 1939, 113: 1596.—Yodice, A. Hemorroides; etio- patogenia y tratamiento. Dia mdd, B. Air, 1931-32, 4: 225. ---- Examination. Eisner, H. Fortschritte in der Diagnose und Behandlung der Hamorrhoiden. KUn. Wschr, 1927, 6: 858-61.—Lentini Diaz, J. Sobre el diagndstico y tratamiento de las hemor- roides. Rev. mdd. Barcelona, 1926, 2. ser, 15: 325-32.— Strauss, H. Ueber die Sauginspektion von Hamorrhoiden. Deut. med. Wschr, 1927, 53: 1391. ---- History. Hippocrates. On hemorrhoids; transl. by F. Adams, p.351-4. 26cm. Bait., 1939. Also Med. Classics, 1938-39, 3: 351-4. Bensaude, R. Historique des hdmorroides. Presse mdd, 1937, 45: 1391-6.—Brodie, B. C. Brodie's pile; lectures on diseases of the rectum; published in the London medical gazette, 16, 26-31, 1935. Med. Classics, 1937-38, 2: 929-40.—Dufour, H. Hdmorroides, que de piqiires on prodigue en ton nom! J. mdd. Paris, 1939, 59: 691.—Ebstein, E. A contribution to the history of hemorrhoids, and their treatment from the time of Hippocrates to the modern bacteriological era. Med. Life, 1928, 35: 5-18, 2 portr.—Laufman, H. The history of hemorrhoids. Am. J. Surg, 1941, 53: 381-7. ---- Inflammation. See also subheading (thrombotic) Bensaude, R. Thrombose et thrombo-phldbite hdmor- roidaires. Prat. mdd. fr, 1935, 16: 83-91.—Boas, I. Be- handlung akut entziindeter Hamorrhoidalknoten. Med. Welt, 1929, 3: 9-11.—Brooke, B. R. Hemorrhoidal infection. Med. Sentinel, 1926, 34: 129-33.—Cain, A. La thrombo- phldbite sus-hdmorroldaire du rectum. Prat. mdd. fr, 1936, 17: 208-10.—Doron, G. J, & Dubowy, E. D. Rontgentherapie der Hamorrhoiden im Stadium der Entziindung (Einklem- mung) Rontgenpraxis, 1936, 8: 693.—Frankel, W. K. In- jektions therapie entziindeter Hamorrhoiden. Deui. med. Wsehr, 1932, 58: 1487. Also Med. Welt, 1928, 2: 1672.— Hartmann. Phldbite hdmorroidaire. Rev. gdn. clin. thdr, 1931, 45: 646.—Tournay, R. La phldbite hdmorroidaire externe et son traitement. J. mdd. Paris, 1932, 52: 519-21. ---- internal. Alley, R. C. Internal hemorrhoids; treatment by non- surgical methods. Kentucky M. J, 1935, 33: 228-35.— Blanchard, C. E. A new conception of internal hemorrhoids. Bull. Off. Pract, 1934, 7:246-9. ------ Internal hemorrhoids. Ibid, 1937-38, 11: 49-56.—Crookall, A. Internal hemor- rhoids; determination of treatment. Northwest M, 1936, 35: 18-20.—Dale, G. C. Technic of ambulatory treatment of internal hemorrhoids. South. M. & S, 1938, 100: 416.— Drueck, C. J. Etiology of internal hemorrhoids. Med. Rec, N. Y, 1940, 152: 15-7. ------ Causes of internal hemor- rhoids. IlUnois M. J, 1939, 75: 159-61. Also Med. Surg. Suggestions, Madras, 1939, 8: 203-8.—Hiller, R. I. Internal hemorrhoids; their pathogenesis and the rationale of injection therapy. Am. J. Surg, 1932, n. ser, 16: 64-7. Also repr.— Hirschman, L. J. Treatment of internal hemorrhoids. Proc. Interst. Postgrad. M. Ass. N. America, 1929, 5: 1-5.—Johnston, E. A. Internal hemorrhoids. J. Am. Coll. Proct, 1934-35, 7: 10-4.—Kilbourne, N. J. Internal haemorrhoids: comparative value of treatment by operative and by injection methods; a survey of 62,910 cases. Ann. Surg, 1934, 99: 200-8. Also repr.—Kincheloe, A. L. Galvanism in the treatment of internal hemorrhoids, with report of case. Kentucky M. J, 1927, 25: 514-7.—Lockhart-Mummery, J. P. Internal piles; diagnosis and treatment. Postgrad. M. J, Lond, 1925-26, 1: 22-7----—■ The treatment of internal piles. Practitioner, Lond, 1931, 126: 495-500. Also Postgrad. M. J, Lond, 1936, 12: 315-8.—MacDonald, E. W. Internal haemorrhage simulat- ing concealed accidental haemorrhage. Nova Scotia M. Bull., HEMORRHOID 564 HEMORRHOID 1940, 19: 586.—Ploeger, A. Ein einfriehes Iiilfsmittel bei der Untersuchung auf innere Hamorrhoiden. Miinch. med. Wschr, 1927. 71: 285- Postlethwaite. F. M. Internal hemor- rhoids. J. Missouri M. Ass.. 1939, 36: 268-71. Riberi, A. Varie operazioni consigllate contro le emorroidi interne e specialmente sul metodo di Leirarlc. Mem. med. contemp, Venez, 1846, 16: 451-7.—Riddoch, J. W. The treatment of internal haemorrhoids. Practitioner, Lond, 1935, 134: 673-7.—Rivero y Heras, J. Procedimiento operatorio para el tratamiento de las hemorroides internas. Mem. Congr. mdd. nac. mex, 1910, 1. Congr.. -172-5.—Valerio, A. Hemor- rhoidas internas e svndroniologia genito-urinaria. Fol. med, Rio, 1931, 12: 175.— Woodall. P. H. Internal hemorrhoids. BuU. Off. Pract, 1930-37, 10: 82; 89. ---- Manifestation. Cavallo, F. La sindrome emmorroidaria. Fol. med. Nap., 1934, 20: 239-49.—Dechterev, V. [Hemorrhoids and their relation to the nervous system] Russ. klin., 1928, 9: Xo. 45, 57-05.— Drueck, C. J. Itching piles. Wisconsin M. Rec, 1911, 14: 170-4. ------ Clinical evidences of hemorrhoids. Clin. M. & S, 1938, 45: 427-9.—Filippi, M. La douleur hdmor- roidaire. Echo mdd. nord, 1939, 3. sdr, 10: 102-8.—Franco, I*. M. L'ittero nella sindrome emorroidaria di Castellino. Fol. med. Nap, 1926, 12: 753 75.— Kanlor. J. L. Hemor- rhoids; medical aspect. Am. J. Suig, 1931. n. ser, 14: 620-3. Also repr.—Montague, J. F. Popular fallacies concerning hemorrhoids. Med. J. & Rec, 1920, 123: 145.------More fallacies concerning hemorrhoids. Ibid, 487. Also repr. ---- Pathology. Blond, K. Zur Pathologie und Therapie des varikosen Symptomenkomplexes des Mastdarms. Wien. klin. Wschr, 1934, 47: 1409-12. Also Wien. med. Wschr, 1934, 84: 090.— Drueck, C. J. External hemorrhoids. Am. Med, 1927, 22: 157-66.—Duprd, E. La maladie heiiiorrhoidaire. Stras- bourg mdd, 1920, 84: pl 2, 189-99.--I.igin, S. V. [Decrease of tactile sensibility of i he mucous membrane of the rectum in patients with hemori boids] Vest, khir, 1930, 20: 208.— Man-hand, J. H. Les tumeurs bdnignes hdmorroidaires. Prat. mdd. fr, 1930, 11: 517-21.—Meredith, O. D. Ball valve hemorrhoids. Bull. Off. Pract, 1936-37, 10: 227.—Valerio, A. Hdmorroides, angiomatose, angiomes ano-rectaux. Arch, mal app. digest. Par, 1934, 24: 708-14— Whitney. E. T, & Keane, J. F. Perianal cryptic tabs. N. England J. M, 1939, 221: 303-6. ■---- Prolapse, protrusion, and strangulation. Gluck, A. *Cure radicale ambulatoire des hemorroides procidentes par la diathermo- coagulation. 40p. 8? Par., 1928. Bensaude, R, Cain, A, & Meyer, P. De la conduite k tenir en prdsence des hemorroides procidentes irrdductibles. Rev. gdn. chn. thdr, 1927, 41: 705-8.—Blanchard, C. e! Acute protrusion with strangulation. Bull. Or). Pract, 1933, 7: 1-3. ------ The management of strangulated hemor- rhoids. Ibid, 1938-39, 12: 218-22.—Blumenthal, N. L. [Surgical treatment of hemorrhoids in the stage of strangula- tion] KUn. med, Moskva, 1933, 11: 145-9.—Bordier, H. Traitement des hdmorroides procidentes par la diathermo- coagulation. Arch, dlectr. mdd, 1921, 31: 353-6. Technique diathermique pour le traitement des hdmorroides procidentes. Monde mdd, 1930, 40: 501-5. ------ Tech- nique du traitement des hdmorroides procidentes par la dia- thermo-coagutation; ses rdsultats. Arch, dlectr. mdd 1931 39: 320-4. Also Rev. gdn. clin. thdr, 1931, 45: 625-8 Radical treatment of prolapsed hemorrhoids by diathermy Med. Herald, 1931, 50: 229-32.—Brockman, W. T. Rectai prolapse and hemorrhoids. J. S. Carolina M. Ass, 1937, 33: 198-200.—Cain, A. Le traitement de la proeidence hdmor- roidaire. Presse mdd, 1939, 47: 1350-2.—Cartwright, E. L. The management of strangulated hemorrhoids. Tr Am Proct. Soc, 1937, 38: 103-19. Also Am. J. Digest. Dis 'l937- 38, 4: 425-7— Drueck, C. J. Protrusions from the anus. Chn. M. 6z >., 1927, 34: 745-50.—Durand-Boisleard. Les prolapsus hemorroidaires de la muqueuse rectale et leur traite- ment par la dia thermocoagulation. Arch, dlectr. mdd, 1927 37: 438740.—Garat, J. A. Tratamiento quirtirgico de las hemorroides estranguladas agudas. Sem. mdd, B. Air, 1940 47: 1135-7.—Gucci, G. Sopra una modificazione di tecnica per le emorroidi prolassate. PoUclinico, 1939, 46: sez. chil- li 1-9.—Hayem, A. La diathermo-coagulation des hdmor- roides procidentes. Echo mdd. nord, 1939, 3. sdr 10- 21-5__ Lockhart-Mummery, J. P. Prolapsed hemorrhoids of ex- cessive dimensions; specimen. Proc. R. Soc. M, Lond 1928- 29, 22: M-et Surg 21.—Pruitt. M. C. Etiology and treatment of strangulated, thrombosed infected, and gangrenous internal hemorrhoids. >outh. M. J, 1939, 32: 68-70—Ross J C 'treatment of prolapsed thrombosed internal haemorrhoids' Lancet, Lond, 1939, 1: 90. ---- Surgery. Hufnagel, E. *Bericht iiber die an der \\ urzburger chirurgischen Klinik in den Jahren 1921-1929 bchandcltcn Haemorrhoiden. 5Gp 8? Wiirzb.. 1931. Ameline, A. Anatomie et chirurgie des hdmorroides. Presse therm, clim, 1932, 73: (ill.—Askew, II. H. Hemorrhoidec- tomy. Bull. Fulton Co. M. Soc, 1940, 14: No. 20, 4.- Hums, G. W. The surgery for piles. Bull. OIL Pract, 1936-37, 10: 57-61.—Connors, R. J. Whv hcmoiroidoetoinies'' II,id 1937-38, 11: 225-8. Also Med. ilec, N. V, 1938, 147: 375-7.- Da Costa, G. Sobre o tratamiento das hemorrhoidas Med contemp, Lisb, 1928, 46: 205. —Deeds, C. R. The treat^ ment ol hemorrhoids; a critique. J. Med, Cincin, 1935-36, 16: 207-9.-—Fansler, W. A. The surgical treatment of hemor- rhoids. Minnesota M, 1931, 17: 254—Fernandez, J. ('. Tratamiento quinirgico de las hemorroides. Bol. inst clin quir, B. Air, 1935, 11: 362-6. Also Sem. mdd, B. Air 1935' 42: pt 2, 1458-02.—Freund. S. J. The surgical treatment of hemorrhoids. Internat. Clin, 1939, n. ser. 2, 3: 192-206, 3 pl.—Garcia Castellanos, J. A. Hemorroides; su triilnmiento quirtirgico. Dfa mdd, B. Air, 1941, 13: 594-7. —Jlirschman, L. J. The surgical treatment of hemorrhoids. Tr. \m Proct' Soc, 1920, 26: 60-73. ------ Hemorrhoidectomy. Internat Chn, 1931, 41. ser, 2: 263-9—Kauzal, G. ISiirjiical treat^ ment of hemorrhoids] Bratisl. lek. listy, 1932, 52: 435.— Lesniowski, A. [Surgical treatment of external hemorrhoidal Polska gaz. lek, 1927, 6: 828-30.—Lynch, J. M. Surgical treatment of hemorrhoids. Am. J. Surg, 1931, n. ser, 14: 624-5. Also repr.—Mates, M. Tratamiento quirtirgico de las hemorroides. Cir. cirujan, Mdx, 1936, 4: 237-41.—Milligan, E. T. C, Morgan, C. N. [et al.] Surgical anatomy of the anai canal, and the operative treatment of haemorrhoids. Lancet Lond, 1937, 2: 1119-24.— Morgan, C. N. Hemorrhoids' Am. J. Surg, 1937, 36: 252-8.—Neumann, R. Anal-Varicen (Hamorrhoiden) und Rectal-Varicen. Deut. Zschr. Chir, 1938, 250: 263-75.—Palant, M. Hemorroides; conceptos actuales de anatomia, clfnica y terapdutica. Bol. Inst, clin quir, B. Air, 1937-38, 14: 84-190.—Palmer, L. A. Hemor- rhoids and operative treatment. Hosp. News, Wash, 1936, 3: No. 10, 19-32, 6 figs.—Rouhier, G. La cure chirurgicale des hdmorrhoides. Mddecine, Par, 1927-28, 9: 984-88.—Ruggi, (i. Le emorroidi studiate sotto il punto di vista chirurgico. Mem Accad. sc. Ist. Bologna, 1924-25, 8. ser, 2: 3-9.—Sarafoff, D. Die Hamorrhoiden und ihre operative Behandlung. Arch klin. Chir, 1931-32, 168: 480-523.—Schnitzler, J. Warm und wie soil man Hamorrhoiden operieren? Wien. klin Wschr, 1927, 40: 789-91.—Stajano, C. A propdsito de la comunicacion del Dr Di Paola: la indicacidn quirtirgica en el sindrome cataclfsmico. Bol. Soc. obst. gin. B. Aires, 1933, 12: 238-40.—Swinton, N. W. The treatment of hemorrhoids. Surg. Clin. N. America, 1939, 19: 669-88.—Szarvas, F. [Opera- tive treatment of hemorrhoids] Orv. hetil, 1930, 74: 541.— Thorsteinsson, E. [Results of operative treatment of hemor- rhoidal tumors] Nord. med, 1939, 4: 3227-40. ---- Surgery: After-treatment, and complica- tions. Ault, G. W. Elimination of pain following hemorrhoidec- tomy. Surgery, 1939, 5: 755-02.—Beckerman, L. S. [Errors, dangers and unforeseen complications in treatment of hemor- rhoids] Vest, khir, 1936, 48: 75-82.—Block, L. H, Greene, B. L, & Wiltrakis, G. A. The use of nupercaine in oil for the alleviation of postoperative pain in hemorrhoidectomies. Illinois M. J, 1938, 73: 238-42.—Brockman, T, & Cain, S, jr. An interesting problem in the after-care of hemorrhoidecto- mies. Tr. Am. Proct. Soc, 1933, 34: 113-21. Also J. S. Carolina M. Ass, 1933, 29: 281-5.—Fischer, A. W. Anal- kanalplastik nach missgluckter Whiteheadoperation. Zbl. Chir, 1934, 61: 157-9.—Florcken, H. Die Beseitigung der Inkontinenz nach der Whiteheadschen Hiimorrhoidenopera- tion. Deut. Zschr. Chir, 1931, 132: 412-4.—Freund, M. H. Hemorrhoidectomy in a case of polycythemia vera. Tr. Am. Proct. Soc, 1930, 31: 21-4.—Hayes, H. T. Hemorrhoidec- tomy: essential factors in minimizing after-pain. Med. Rec, Houston, 1934, 28: 514-6.—Hertzler, A. E. The use of dio- tnane in the control of after pain in hemorrhoidectomy. Am. J. Obst, 1934, 27: 301.—Hibshman, H. Z. Report of 2 cases with autopsy. Tr. Am. Proct. Soc, 1933, 34: 60.—James, J. M. Recurrence of hemorrhoids after treatment or operation. J. Am. Coll. Proct, 1924, 6: 59.—Jamieson, W. R. Treatment after hemorrhoidectomy. Southwest. M, 1928, 12: 439.— Jerusalem, M. Wie soil die Nachbehandlung nach Opera- tionen wegen Hamorrhoiden und Varizen durchgefuhrt werden? frf^? ' Wien' 1931' 5: 362- Also Wien- klin- Wschr, 1931, 44: 1319.—Landsman, A. A. Sloughing and prolapse of the rectum following operation for hemorrhoids. Tr. Am. to°Cho " 1926' 27: 57~9- Also BuU- 0ff- Pract, 1938-39, 12: 123.—Lebedev, A. A. [Technique and management of the post-operative period in operations for hemorrhoids] Vest. khir, 1939, 58: 47-9.—Merar, T. J. The prevention of pain foUowing hemorrhoidectomy. Am. J. Surg, 1939, 43: 45-50. Also repr.—Perry, C. C. Hemorrhoidectomy; with special reference to postoperative care and complications. Ohio M. J, 1939, 35: 54-7.—Rowntree, C. The complications of operations for piles. CUn. J, Lond, 1930, 59: 606-9. -----■ Baldwin, H. [et al.] Complications of operations for piles. Lancet, Lond, 1929, 2: 1360-2. ------ Discussion on the compUcations of operations for piles. Proc. R. Soc. M, Lond., 1929-30, 23: Sect. Surg, 38-47—Simmons. N. J. HEMORRHOID 565 HEMORRHOID Elimination of postoperative pain following hemorrhoidectomy. N. England J. M, 1936, 214: 20-2— Skir, I, & Marino, A. W. M. A complications of hemorrhoidectomy, with special consideration of structure: a study of 269 cases. Med. Times, N Y, 1936, 64: 271-4.—Smith, D. Whitehead deformity. J.Am. M. Ass, 1928, 91: 879. Also Tr. Am. Proct. Soc, 1929, 29: 75-7.—Volkova, M. A. [Working capacity following opera- tion for hemorrhoids] Sovet. vrach. J, 1938, 42: 767-70.— Woolf, A. E. M. Three important points in the post-operative treatment of haemorrhoids. Postgrad. M. J, Lond, 1932, 8:23. --- Surgery: Anesthetization. Hirschman, L. J. Hemorrhoidectomy under regional anesthesia. J. Michigan M. Soc, 1939, 38: 402-4.—Martin, E. G. Hemorrhoids, the composite technique, and local anesthesia. J. Michigan M. Soc, 1925, 24: 593. Also Tr. Am. Proct. Soc, 1926, 26: 80-2.—Schulkey, W. E. Sacral anaesthesia in hemorrhoidectomy. Texas J. M, 1930-31, 26: 342.—Terterian, A. A. [Chininum bimuriaticum car- bamidatum as local anesthesia in operation for hemorrhoids] Vest, khir, 1930, 46: 243.—Tucker, C. C. Hemorrhoid opera- tion under local anesthetic. J. Kansas M. Soc, 1930, 31: 395-401. --- Surgery: Clamp and suture. Deavor, T. L. The two clamp method of removing hemor- rhoids; a new and simple procedure. Am. J. Surg, 1920, n. ser, 1: 193-7.—Gohrbandt, E. Silberklemmen zur Blut- stillung. Zbl. Chir, 1932, 59: 2995.—Hoffmann, W. H. Eine neue Hamorrhoidalklemme. Miinch. med. Wschr, 1927, 74: 1855.—Jiano, J. Cure radicale des hdmorroides avec mes pinces. P. verb. Congr. fr. chir, 1930, 39: 3G5-9— Oden, C. L. A. A clamp for hemorrhoidectomy. Tr. Am. Proct. Soc. (1941) 1942, 42: 238-40.—Thiele, G. H. Hemorroidec- tomy by clamp and cautery. Month. Bull. Kansas City CUn. Soc, 1933, 9: 3. --- Surgery: Ligature by transfixion. Cordes, F. *Haemorrhoiden und ihre opera- tive Behandlung, insbesondere durch Ligatur. 23p. 8? Konigsb., 1936. Groth, O. K. *Ueber Ligaturbehandlung der Haemorrhoiden. 23p. 8? Bresl., 1930. Hayes, H. T. The removal of hemorrhoids by the ligature operation. Texas J. M, 1929-30, 25: 210-3.—Lemaire, E. Un procddd rapide de cure radicale des hdmorrho'ides. Progr. mdd. Par, 1928, 43: 1290.—Peiser, A. Zur Technik der Ligaturbehandlung der inneren Hamorrhoiden. Zbl. Chir, 1930, 57: 1524-6. --- Surgery: Methods. Bacon, H. E. A new method in the surgical treatment of hemorrhoids. J. M. Soc. N. Jersey, 1941, 38: 636-8.—Bau- meister, C, & Moon, L. A complete technique of hemorrhoid- ectomy. Surg. Gyn. Obst, 1940, 71: 360-8.—Bowman, F. B. Painless, bloodless, and safe haemorrhoidectomy. Canad. M. Ass. J, 1938, 38: 430-2.—Burrows, W. F., & Burrows, E. C. Simplifying rectal surgery, with special reference to hemor- rhoidectomy. Med. J. & Rec, 1929, 129: 216-8.—Caiman, A. S. Submucous hemorrhoidectomy. Am. J. Surg, 1939, 43: 577-80. ------ The submucous method in the treatment of anorectal diseases. Ibid, 1941, 53: 428-33.—Campbell, F. B. Hemorrhoidectomy by simple excision. Month. BuU. Kansas City CUn. Soc, 1933, 9: 5. ------& Thiele, G. H. Hemor- rhoidectomy. Tr. Am. Proct. Soc, 1936, 37: 203-13.—Cart- wright, E. L. Hemorrhoidectomy versus office treatments. J. Indiana M. Ass, 1934, 27:431-4.—Cureleanu, T. [Ambulatory surgical treatment of hemorrhoids] Spitalul, 1940, 60: 72-8.— Eaton, C. Hemorrhoidectomy in situ. West. J. Surg, 1938, 46: 603. ------ A method of proctorrhaphy for advanced hemorrhoidal lesions. Ibid, 1939, 47: 402-4—Emiliani, P. Metodo plastico SoUeri per la cura chirurgica deU'emorroidi. Morgagni, 1932, 74: 670-5.—F., W. A. Standardization of proctologic technique. J. Lancet, 1942, 62: 23.—Fansler, W. A. Hemorrhoidectomy; an anatomical method. J. Lancet, 1931,51:529-31. ------ Hemorrhoidectomy; motion picture presentation. Tr. Am. Proct. Soc. (1941) 1942, 42: 234-6. -----& Anderson, J. K. A plastic operation for certain types of hemorrhoids. J. Am. M. Ass, 1933, 101: 1064-6. Also repr.—Ferri, G. Note di tecnica chirurgica; il metodo Bagozzi nella cura chirurgica delle emorroidi. Boll. spec. med. chir, 1929, 3: 73-82.—Galli, U. M. L'emorroidectomia di Penning- ton modificata ed il suo valore pratico. Gazz. med. lombarda, 1930, 89: 115-22.—Giles, R. C. The principles and technic of the surgical treatment of hemorrhoids. J. Nat. M. Ass, N. Y, 1926, 18: 202-6.—Gorsch, R. V. Electrosurgery in hemor- rhoids. Med. Rec, N. Y, 1936, 144: 226-9.—Gross, L. Zur operationslosen Hamorrhoidenbehandlung; vorlaufige Mittei- lung. Med. Klin, Berl, 1926, 22: 1230.—Guild, W. A. The American operation. J. Am. Inst. Homeop, 1934, 27: 214- 6.—Hardin, B. F. The surgical and non-surgical treatment of hemorrhoids. Memphis M. J, 1936, 11: No. 10, 7-11..— Harrington, K. H. The surgical technique for a hemorrhoid- ectomy. Eclect. M. J, 1926, 86: 529-32.—Hiden, J. H. Experience with an efficient method of operating upon hemor- ™ ,'c ad,aP*ed to general practice in rural districts. South. M. & S, 1937, 99: 327-9.—Hirschman. L. J. Simple hemor- rhoidectomy technique with special reference to relaxation and exposure without speculums or retractors. Tr. Am. Proct Soc. (1941) 1942, 42: 231-6. ------ The technic of a simple and effective hemorrhoidectomy. J. Kansas M. Soc, 1942 43: 45-9.—Huppert, E. I. Hemorrhoidectomy with the Collings electrotome. Med. J. & Rec, 1929, 129: 401-3.—Jensen, J. [Ambulatory operative treatment of hemorrhoidal nodulesl Ugeskr heger, 1929, 91: 419-23.—Jobbagy, A. [New surgical method for hemorrhoids] Orvoskdpzds, 1934, 24: nov. kulonf (Verebdly Festschr.) 299-302.—Kehar, D. R. Treatment of haemorrhoids by strangulation and snipping method. Ind. M Gaz, 1925, 60: 362-6.—Kleckner, M. S. The treatment of hemorrhoids; a comparison of the operative and the non-opera- tive methods. Pennsylvania M. J, 1934-35, 38: 163-8.— Lynch, J. M. Hemorrhoidectomy. Am. J. Surg, 1926, n. ser I: 245-8.—Martel, T. de. Ablation des hdmorroides. In Prat. chir. lllustr. (Pauchet, V.) 3. ed., Par, 1938, 22: 123-33.— Mikoshiba, R. Zur Behandlung der Hamorrhoiden. Chirurg, 1934, 6: 131-3.—Moore, E. Hemorrhoidectomy with special reference to a new technique and the avoidance of pain. J. Oklahoma M. Ass, 1942, 35: 4-8.—Moore, W. J. Electro- surgical haemorrhoidectomy. Med. Press & Circ, Lond, 1938, 197: 336-9.—Morgan, C. N. Haemorrhoids; surgical procedure in general practice. Brit. M. J, 1939, 1: 399.—Patterson, F. A modification of the Murray submucous hemorrhoidectomy. Clin. M. & S, 1940, 47: 183.—Peters, K. O. Zur Frage der Hamorrhoidenbehandlung. Arch. kUn. Chir, 1933-34, 178: 718-36.—Samy, M. A new operation for haemorrhoids. Med. Press & Circ, Lond, 1935, 191: 156-63.—Smith, N. D. Hemor- rhoidectomy: a plastic operation. Minnesota M, 1937, 20: 233-6. Also Collect. Papers Mayo Clin, 1936, 28: 261-5.— Stevenson, D. L. Operation for piles. Lancet, Lond, 1942, 1: 91.—Szarvas, F. Ein neues Verfahren zur Operation der Nodi haemorrhoidales. Zbl. Chir, 1930, 57: 650-2.—Tephany, A. Les hdmorroides sont-elles justiciables du bistouri, de la phldbo- sclerose ou de la diathermo-coagulation? amdUorations apportdes k l'instrumentation. Monde mdd, 1933, 43: 953-62.—Thomi- son, H. E. Hemorrhoidectomy as an office procedure. Med. World, 1934, 52: 489-91.—Tillmann, G. Zur Behandlung der Hamorrhoiden. Chirurg, 1934, 6: 212.—Zemgulys, J. [Ambu- latory surgical treatment of hemorrhoids] Medicina, Kaunas, 1940, 21: 620-8. ---- Surgery: Whitehead's operation. Ebbe, H. *Die Ergebnisse der Haemor- rhoiden-Operation nach Whitehead in der chirur- gischen Universitatsklinik zu Heidelberg aus den Jahren 1923 bis 1933 [HeidelbergJ 23p. 21cm. Bottrop, 1938. Biittner. Zur Technik der Hamorrhoidenoperation nach Whitehead. Zbl. Chir, 1935, 62: 2090—CaKnich, G. Erfah- rungen mit der Hamorrhoidenoperation nach Whitehead. Ibid, 1154-7.—Dubinsky, A. Zur Whitehead'schen Hamor- rhoidenoperation. Ibid, 1934, 61: 1231-4 [Bemerkungen von A. W. Fischer] 1234.—Herrmannsdorfer, A. Ergebnisse und Technik der Haemorrhoidenoperation nach Whitehead. Med. Welt, 1937, 11: 423-5.—Leo, E. La radicale di Whitehead, operazione elettiva nelle emorroidi. Gazz. osp, 1931, 52: 1415- 22.—Metivet, G. A propos de l'operation de Whitehead. Presse mdd, 1939, 47: 947.—Newman, S. E. The technic of a radical hemorrhoidectomy. Tr. Am. Proct. Soc, 1934, 35: 36-45. ——■— The technic of a radical hemorrhoidectomy; a procedure with the elimination of the element of pain. J. Missouri M. Ass, 1937, 34: 114-9.—Norwood, R. R. Excision of external hypertrophied tissue. J. Am. Coll. Proct, 1933—34, 6: 219.—Papayoannou, T. L'opdration Whitehead pour la cure radicale des hdmorroides mdrite-t-elle les inconvdnients sdrieux qu'on lui reproche? J. Egypt. M. Ass, 1933, 16: 567-84. Also Zbl. Chir, 1933, 60: 1061-5.—Schum, H. Die radikale Opera- tion der Hamorrhoiden nach Whitehead und deren angebliche Gefahren. Med. Welt, 1934, 8: 1116-20.—Toth, B. Ueber die Ursachen der ungiinstigen Ergebnisse der Whitehead'schen Operation. Zbl. Chir, 1941, 68: 593-6.—Viacava, F. A, Mestre, E. [et al.] Mdtodo de Whitehead modifioado por le Dr Blaye. Prensa mdd. argent, 1937, 24: 729-32.—Volker, W. Die Ergebnisse der Hamorrhoidenoperation nach Whitehead. Beitr. khn. Chir, 1936, 164: 437-43. ---- thrombotic. Caldas, J. M. Comentario sobre certa conduta cirurgica na hemorroida trombotica. Brasil med, 1941, 55: 616.—Chernoff, G. W. Diagnosis and treatment of thrombotic external hemorrhoids. Med. World, 1940, 58: 40.—Crookall, A. The treatment of external thrombotic hemorrhoids. Med. J. & Rec, 1927, 126: 436-8.—Held, E. Zur Behandlung der Thrombose ausserer Hamorrhoidalknoten. Schweiz. med. Wschr, 1939, 69: 300.—Hirschman, L. J. The emergency treatment of thrombotic and prolapsed hemorrhoids. Am. J. Surg 1939, 46: 674-80.—Johnston, E. A. Thrombotic hemorrhoids. J. Am. Coll. Proct, 1933-34, 6: 239; 242.— Miller, S. E. External thrombotic hemorrhoids. Hosp. News, Wash, 1936, 3: No. 10, 15-8.—Yoemans, F. C. Fissure of the anus and thrombotic hemorrhoids. Am. J. Surg, 1929, n. ser, 6: 426-9. HEMORRHOID 566 HEMORRHOID ---- Treatment. Acnew, W. P. Treatment of hemorrhoids, and other non-malignant rectal diseases. 99p. 16! San Franc, 1890. ---- The same. Diagnosis and treatment of hemorrhoids and other nonmalignant rectal dis- eases. 2. ed. HSp. 16? San Franc, 1891. Blond, K. Haemorrhoids and their treatment. 140p. 23cm. Brist,, 1940. Bctet, A. *Le traitement medical, curatif, ambulatoire des hdmorroides. 13p. 24cm. Par. [1939] Montague, J. F. The modern treatment of hemorrhoids. 296p. 8? Phila. [1926] Also 2. ed. rev. 298p. 1928. Also 3. ed. 318p. [1934] Ozexxe, E. Hygiene prophylactique des hemorroldaires. 175p. 20cm. Par., 1923. Alley, R. C. Hemorrhoids; local and systemic considera- tions. Kentucky M. J, 1940, 38: 212-4.—Banks, B. The treatment of hemorrhoids and pruritus ani. West Virginia M. J, 1934, 30: 122-8.—Boas, J. Dieta na constipacao chronica e nas hemorrhoides. Rev. med. cir. Brasil, 1926, 34: 2-24.—Corbett, J. J. Office treatment of hemorrhoids. Am. J. Surg, 1940, 50: 641-4.—Craven, W. W. The handling of hemorrhoids. South. M. & S, 1940, 102: 14-0.—Crook, E. A. Anatomy in regard to the treatment of piles. S. Barth. Hosp. J, Lond, 1924-25, 32: 189.— Danis, J. T. Haemorrhoids; their significance and treatment. Lniv. Toronto M. J, 1939- 40, 17: 209-17.—Drueck, C. J. The treatment of hemorrhoids. Med. Rec, N. Y, 1938, 148: 293-0.—Furniss, A. Haemor- rhoids and their treatment. Nurs. Times, Lond, 1940, 36: 533-5.—Gabriel, W. B. The treatment of haemorrhoids. Practitioner, Lond, 1931, 126: 111-20. Also Brit. M. J, 1939, 2: 1206-9, pl. -Haskell, B. The office treatment of hemor- rhoids and other common anal conditions. Med. Clin. N. America, 1939, 23: 1683-94. Hillen-.and, P., & Caube, R. Traitement medical des hdmorroidr s. Bull. gdn. ther, 1937, 188: 37-9. Also in Thdr. mdd. actual. Par. (1937) 1938, 4: 37-9.—Holehan, M. W. The treatment of hemorrhoids. J. Tennessee M. Ass, 1942, 35: 43-8.—Hullsiek, H. 10. The care of hemorrhoid patients. Minnesota M, 1927, 10: 377-9. - Juda, A. The non-sursical treatment of haemorrhoids. ILne- fua, Tel Aviv, 1940, 18: No. 5, 2— Krause, G. L. Hemor- rhoids; study of a series of cases improved by conservative treatment. J. Missouri M. Ass, 1939, 36: 20-4.—Leoni Iparraguirre, C. A. Hemorroides; clinica y tratamiento. Dia mdd, B. Air, 1933-34, 6: 471.—Lersey, P. [Treatment of hemorrhoids] Lgeskr. Leger, 1930, 92: 474.—Lotsch, F. Die Behandlung der Hamorrhoiden. Fortsch. Ther, 1931, 7: 298-11.- -Lynch, J. M, & Hurley, V. Treatment of hemor- rhoids. Am. J. Digest. Dis, 1934-35, 1: 409-12.—McEvedy, P. Treatment of haemorrhoids. Med. Press & Circ, Lond, 1938, 197: 542-4.—Melchior, E. Die Behandlung der Hamor- rhoiden. Ther. Gegenwart, 1927, 68: 489-96.—Miller, R. B. The rational treatment of hemorrhoids. U. S. Nav. M. Bull, 1930, 28: 34-66.—Mitchell, W. E. M. The treatment of haemorrhoids. Canad. M. Ass. J, 1926, 16: 1358-60.— Montague, J. F. The successful treatment of hemorrhoids without operation. Med. Times, N. Y, 1933, 61: 101-4.— Morgan, C. N. Haemorrhoids. In Treatm. Gen. Pract, Lond, 1940, 4: 284^300— Nelson, B. A. Treatment of hemor- rhoids. J. Kansas M. Soc, 1932, 33: 229-32.—Pauchet, V. Tratamiento de las hemorroides. Cron. mdd. mex, 1934, 33: 1-10.—Piquinela, J. A. Hemorroides. Accidn mdd, B. Air. 1940, 10: 666-71.—Pruitt. M. C. Palliative, operative and injection treatment of hemorrhoids. South. M. J, 1930 23: 1098-103.—Rainey, W. R. Hemorrhoids. In Modern Med Ther. (Barr, D. P.) Bait, 1940, 2: 2340-8.—Sadler, L. K. The medical and surgical treatment of hemorrhoids. Med Woman J, 1930, 37: 89-93.—Schwartz, A. Traitement des hdmorroides. Paris mdd, 1930, 77: 325.—Stalder, H. Die Hamorrhoiden und ihre Behandlung. Schweiz. med. Wschr 1931, 61: 1098-102.—Stuart, W. J. Haemorrhoids and their treatment. Edinburgh M. J, 1938, 45: 665-77.—Terrell, E. H. Selecting the treatment for hemorrhoids. Tr Am' Proct. Soc, 1931, 32: 166-73. ------ The treatment of hemorrhoids. South. M. & S, 1932, 94: 153-5. Also repr Also Med. World, 1936, 54: 293-7.—Valerio, A. Sobre o tratamento de certas hemorrhoidas. Fol. med, Rio, 1930, 11: 34*.—Williamson, H. The treatment of piles. Ind. M. Gaz!, 1937, 72: 34-7.—Zorraquin, G. Hemorroides; su concepto clinico terapdutico. Rev. mdd. cubana, 1933, 44: 249-59. ---- Treatment: Diathermy, and electricity. Arnheim, E. E. Hemorrhoidectomy with the high fre- quency electric current. Am. J. Surg, 1938, 41: 45-8.__ Bamberger, G. W. Hemorrhoidectomy by electrocoagulation (.diathermy) with report of 200 cases. Am. J. Phys. Ther. 1930, 7: 100.—Bierman. W. Surgical diathermy in the trea£ ment of htemorrhoids. Brit. J. Radiol, B. A. R. P. Sect 1926 31: 178-85, 2 pl.------Surgical diathermy in the removal of hemorrhoids. Am. J. Surg, 1927, n. ser, 2: 575-8. Also repr.------Hemorrhoidectomy bv means of tho high frequency current. Clin. M. & S, 1927, 34: 660-3. Also Am. J. Surg, 1931, n. ser, 14: 626--30. Also repr.----- The removal of hemorrhoids by means of the hiirh frequency current. Arch. Phys. Ther, 1928, 9: 5is 52. Blanco. R. I, Electrocoagulation of hemorrhoids. J. Philippine Islands M Ass, 1934. 14: 396-9.—Bokenham. T. .1. Trnitoment des hemorrhoides; leurs complications par les courants de h,..... frequence. Ann. dlectrob, Lille, 1905, 8: 206-9--Bordier, II. Remarques sur le traitement des hdmorroides externes par la diathermie. Arch, diced, mdd, 1922, 32: 193. Copeland, C. P. Galvanism in the treatment of hemorrhoids. Med World, 1936, 54: 48.—Cotte, G. Sur le traitement des hemor- roides par la diathermic et la diathermo-coagulation. Lyon mdd, 1929, 143: 153-63.—Delator, G. A propos de la dia- thermo-coagulation des hdmorrhoides; paralldle avec les avantages de la fibrose curative. BuU. .Soc. mdd. Paris, 1928, 320-3.—Deutsch, W. F. Electro-coagulation of hemorrhoids Am. J. Phys. Ther, 192(1-27, 3: 500.—Dupeyrac. G. Lea courants de haute-frdquence dans le traitement. des hdmor- roides et de la fissure anale. Marseille mdd, 1931, 68:539-47.— Durand-Boisleard, M. Whitehead ou diathermocoagula- tion. J. mdd. Paris, 1931, 51: 537.—Friedel. Traitement des hdmorroides par la diathermocoagulation. Paris mdd, 1930, 75: 326-9.—Furniss, H. D. Hemorrhoid clamp to be used with diathermy apparatus. Phys. Ther, 1929, 47: 497-9.— Goldfarb, S. Electrocoagulation of hemorrhoids; a simplified and efficient office technique. Med. Rec, N. Y, 1939, 150: 255-7.—Harvey, F. The treatment of hemorrhoids by gal- vanism. Clin. M. & S, 1935, 42: 596-601.—Keesey, W. E. Obliteration of hemorrhoids with negative galvanism. Arch Phys. Ther, 1934, 15: 533-40.—Kobak, D. Medical dia- thermy in the treatment of hemorrhoids. Ibid, 1930, 11: 605-8. -Marchand, J. H. Traitement dlectrique des hdmor- roides. .1. mdd. fr, 1929, 18: 63-5. Also Gaz. mdd. France, 1930, 4: Suppl. radiol, 11-9.—Mayer, P. Du traitement diathermique mddical des hdmorroides. J. mdd. Paris, 1927, 46: 47.—Meira, M. Tratamento das hemorrhoidas pela coagulacfio diathermica. Rev. brasil. med. pharm, 1933, 9: 269-77.—Meyer, P. Des courants de diathermie dans le traitement des hdmorroides. Evolut. thdr. Par, 1927, 8: 8-13.—Morgan, J. D. Surgical diathermy in hemorrhoids. Chn. M. & S, 1927, 34: 689-92.—Neri, C. La diatermia e la diatermo-coagulazione neUa cura dello emorroidi. Minerva med. Tor, 1927, 7: 492.—Neuffer, H. Ueber Kauterisation als Methode der Wahl bei der Behandlung von Hamorrhoiden und Karbunkeln. Beitr. klin. Chir, 1928, 143: 737-42.— Passler, H. W. Die elektrische Operation der Hamorrhoiden. Zbl. Chir, 1932, 59: 2405.—Palant, M. Diatermocoagulacidn de las hemorroides. Sem. mdd, B. Air, 1933, 40: 2058-02.— Kager, E. H. [Surgical diathermy of hemorrhoidal nodules] Ugeskr. laeger, 1930, 92: 052.—Ronneaux, G. Du traitement des hdmorrhoides par les courants de haute frdquence; ses inconvdnicnts possibles. Ann. dlectrob, Lille, 1906, 9: 630.— Schiile. Die Behandlung der Hamorrhoiden durch den Thermokauter. Munch, med. Wschr, 1933, 80: 848.— Seeuwen, H. Le traitement des hdmorrhoides et des fissures sphinctdralgiques. Ann. dlectrob, LiUe, 1909, 12: 827-30.— Sigmond, H. W. Positive galvanism for the treatment of hemorrhoids. Med. Herald, 1926, 45: 203-6.—Stembo, L. Dreissig durch Arsonvalisation geheilte Hamorrhoidalfiille. Rapp. Congr. internat. physiothdr, 1905, 1. Congr, No. 58, 1-3.----■—■ Trente cas de gudrison d'hdmorrhoides au moyen de la haute frdquence. Ann. dlectrob, Lille, 1906, 9: 311.— Surmont, J. Technique de la cure radicale des hdmorroides par la diathermo-coagulation. Paris mdd, 1930, 75: 363-8.— Thielemans, L. Electro-coagulation diathermique d'hdmor- roides. Bruxelles mdd, 1928-29, 9: 1317.—Treatment (The) of hemorrhoids with negative galvanism. Phys. Ther, 1935, 10: 3-7, ch.—Vaidya, A. H. Uniterminal electrocoagulation of hemorrhoids. Clin. M. & S, 1939, 46: 413.—Van Dyk, C. G. L. The treatment of haemorrhoids with negative gal- vanism. S. Afr. M. J, 1939, 13: 124-6.—Waring, J. B. H. Electro-coagulation treatment of hemorrhoids. Am. J. Phys. Ther, 1925-26, 2: 350-2. ------ Improved hemorrhoidal technic. Virginia M. Month, 1926-27, 53: 462-5.—Warshaw, D. Electrothermic hemorrhoidectomy. Am. J. Surg, 1931, n. ser, 11: 45-50. Also repr.—Whitcombe, W. S. Treatment of haemorrhoids by the galvano-cautery. Brit. AI. J, 1928, 2: 1035.—Zehr, N. Submucous coagulation of hemorrhoids. Arch. Phys. Ther, 1934, 15: 556. ---- Treatment: Injection. Goldbacher, L. Hemorrhoids; the injection treatment, and pruritus ani. 2. ed. 207p. 8°. Phila., 1931. McAusland, S. The cure of haemorrhoids and varicose veins. 2. ed. 77p. 8? Lond., 1934. Miller, C. C. The injection treatment of hemorrhoids. 124p. 12? Chic, 1929. Pruitt, M. C. Injection treatment of in- ternal hemorrhoids. 137p. 8? S. Louis, 1929. HEMORRHOID 567 HEMORRHOID Yotjnt, S. T. Treatment of hemorrhoids by injections of carbolic acid and other substances. 63p. 18? Lafayette, Ind., 1887. Anderson, H. G. The injection method for the treatment of hemorrhoids. Bull. Off. Pract, 1936-37,10: 175-8.—Anderson, J. K. The injection treatment of hemorrhoids. Clin. Med, 1941, 48: 42.—Bacon, H. E, & Price, H. A. The injection treatment of hemorrhoids. CUn. M. & S, 1936, 43: 288-91.— Bacon, H. E, & Wolfe, F. D. The injection treatment of hemorrhoids. Illinois M. J, 1942, 81: 202-5.—Balch, F. G, jr. The injection treatment of internal hemorrhoids. N. England J. M, 1935, 212: 57-60.—Beaujean. Diagnostic et traitement scldrosant des hdmorroides. BruxeUes mdd, 1932-33, 13: 881-6.—Becker, J. B. The injection treatment of internal hemorrhoids. Med. J. & Rec, 1933, 137: 503.—Bensaude, R, & Oury, P. Les injections scldrosantes dans le traitement des hdmorroides. J. mdd. fr, 1929, 18: 58-62.—Beveraggi, D. H. Hemorroides; su tratamiento por las inyeceiones modi- ficadoras. Cr6n. mdd. mex, 1933, 32: 7-14.—Bonheim, P. Die Injektionsbehandlung der Hamorrhoidalknoten. Med. Klin, Berl, 1927, 23: 870. Also Deut. med. Wschr, 1928, 54: 1844.—Brockman, T. The injection method of treating hemorrhoids. South. M. & S, 1931, 93: 96-8.—Bumm. R. Ueber die Injektionsbehandlung der Hamorrhoiden. Chirurg, 1933, 5: 814-6.—Campbell, F. B. Injection treatment for hemorrhoids. J. Kansas M. Soc, 1927, 27: 9. Also J. Missouri M. Ass, 1928, 25: 297-9.—Crowe, H. E. The injection treat- ment for hemorrhoids. China M. J, 1926, 40: 417-9.— Dekater, G, & Vendel, R. L. A propos de la fibrose curative des hdmorroides par injections. Presse mdd, 1928, 36: 1329.— Dichter, I. [Sclerosing treatment of hemorrhoids] Romania med, 1937, 15: 28.—Drueck, C. J. Sclerosing treatment of hemorrhoids. CUn. M. & S, 1940, 47: 56-8.—Duff, T. A. J. Injection treatment of haemorrhoids. BuU. Acad. M. Toronto, 1934-35, 8: 106-8.—Eckl, K. Die Injektionsbehandlung der Hamorrhoiden. Wien. med. Wschr, 1936, 86: 137-40 — Eisner, H. Die Injektionsbehandlung der Hamorrhoiden. Arch. Verdauungskr, 1928, 43: 128-34. Also Deut. med. Wschr, 1930, 56: 180; 1932, 58: 1324.—Fagan, E. P. Injection treatment of internal hemorrhoids. Surg. CUn. N. America, 1933, 13: 1337-43.—Felch. M. F. The injection treatment of internal hemorrhoids. Mil. Surgeon, 1931, 68: 760-5.— Fernandez, J. C. Tratamiento esclerosante de las hemor- roides. Dfa med, B. Air, 1931-32, 4: 325.—Garin, H. The injection treatment of haemorrhoids. J. M. Ass. S. Africa, 1928, 2: 549.—Glaser, A. Die Injektionsbehandlung der Hamorrhoiden. Med. Welt, 1934, 8: 192.—Gorsch, R. V, & Smith, C. D. Injection treatment of hemorrhoids. J. M. Soc. N. Jersey, 1936, 33: 620-30.—Harrington, K. H. The injection treatment of hemorrhoids. Med. World, 1937, 55: 119-21.—Harvey, R. S. The injection treatment of haemor- rhoids. In Postgrad. Surg. (Maingot, R.) N. Y, 1936, 2: 3263-74.—Hayden, E. P. Internal hemorrhoids; injection treatment. N. England J. M, 1930, 203:218-20.—Hook, W. G. The injection treatment of internal hemorrhoids. Kansas City M. J, 1939, 15: No. 12, 15-8.—Howard, C. The treat- ment of haemorrhoids by injection. Lancet, Lond, 1929, 1: 158.—Hurley, V. Injection treatment of internal hemorrhoids. Am. J. Surg, 1937, 36: 259-61.—Injection treatment—varicose veins, internal hemorrhoids, hernia and hydrocele. Surg. Equip, 1937, 4: 4-5.—Lloyd-Davies, O. V. The injection treatment of haemorrhoids. Practitioner, Lond, 1939, 142: 751-60.—Mabrey, R. E., & Speare, G. S. Hemorrhoids; with special reference to injection treatment. N. England J. M, 1939, 220: 592-5.—McEvedy, P. G. The injection treatment of haemorrhoids. Lancet, Lond, 1931, 2: 17-9.— Maingot, R. The injection treatment of haemorrhoids. Med. Press & Circ, Lond, 1932, 133: 343; 363.—Marino, A. W. M. Injection treatment of hemorrhoids. Am. J. Surg, 1934, 23: 366-70. Also repr.—-Martin, C. L. The injection treatment of hemorrhoids. Surg. CUn. N. America, 1936, 16: 337-43.— Mason, W. H. Injection treatment of hemorrhoids. Kentucky M. J, 1932, 30: 59-64.—Meisen, V. [Injection treatment of hemorrhoids] Ugeskr. keger, 1928, 90: 523-8.—Oury, P, & Nichita, V. [Injection treatment of hemorrhoids] Rev. St. med, Bucur, 1929 18: 1221-8.—PaveL I. [Sclerotic injections in treatment of hemorrhoids] Romania med, 1930, 8: 79.—Pretty, H. G. The injection treatment of haemor- rhoids. Canad. M. Ass. J, 1934, 31: 29-32.—Price, W. H. The injection treatment of internal hemorrhoids. Clin. Med, 1926, 33: 160-8. Also West. M. Rev, 1926, 31: 259-77 — Reuther, T. F., & Almquist, C. O. Indications for the injection treatment of hemorrhoids. J. Indiana M. Ass, 1940, 33: 306-8.—Rickert, C. M. Radical cure of hemorrhoids by the injection method. CUn. M. & S, 1927, 34: 124.—Robb, D. The treatment of internal haemorrhoids by injection. N. Zealand M. J, 1929-30, 28: 335-41. Also Pract. Med, Delhi, 1930, 28: 177-81.—Rose, B. T. The treatment of haemorrhoids by injection methods. Birmingham M. Rev, 1927, n. ser, 2: 217-9.—Smith, F. C. Injection treatment of internal hemor- rhoids. Med. World, 1939, 57: 231-4.—Sodre, L. O trata- mento das hemorroidas por meio de injecgoes esclerosantes. Brasil med, 1925, 39: pt 2, 143-51.—Stanton, F. D. Injection treatment of hemorrhoids. J. Am. Osteopath. Ass, 1930-31, 30: 316-8.—Strombeck, J. P. [Injection treatment in hemor- rhoids] Sven. lak. tidn, 1931, 28: 897-903.—Stuart, W. J. Haemorrhoids and their treatment. In Edinburgh Postgrad. Lect. (1938-39) 1940, 1: 326-38.—Swinton, N. W. The injection treatment of hemorrhoids. Lahey Clin. Bull, 1940 1: No. 6, 21-5.—Szegedi, A. Die Injektionsbehandlung der Hamorrhoidalknoten. Zschr. arztl. Fortbild, 1934 31- 435 Also Gy6gyaszat, 1934, 74: 302; 1935, 75: 802. Also Orv' hetil, 1936, 80: meU, 89.—Terrell, E. H. Treatment of hemorrhoids by injection. Tr. Am. Proct. Soc, 1926 26: 73-9. Also Virginia M. Month, 1926-27, 53: 13-6.—Valory. Le traitement des hdmorroides par injections scldrosantes Loire mdd, 1933, 47: 271-5.—Wells, H. O. The injection treatment of hemorrhoids. Med. World, 1936, 54: 116.— Yeomans, F. C. Injection treatment of hemorrhoids. Am. J. Surg, 1931, n. ser, 14: 489-91. Also in Sclerosing Therapy (Yeomans, F. C.) Bait, 1939, 289-318. ---- Treatment: Injection: Choice of sclerosing fluid. Bensaude, R. Les injections scldrosantes dans le traitement des hdmorroides. Rev. mdd. fr, 1930, 11: 241-6.—Chene, P., & Dubarry, J. Hdmorroides et traitement scldrosant. J. mdd. Bordeaux, 1935, 112: 555-63.—Cohn, B. Hamorrhoidenbe- handlung durch Antiphlebin-Einspritzung. Med. Klin, Berl, 1933, 29: 124.—Eldering, B. Zur Hamorrhoidenbehandlung mit Alkohohnjektion. Deut. med. Wschr, 1928, 54: 569.— Eisner, H. Die Behandlung der Hamorrhoiden mit Alkohol- injektionen. Ibid, 1927, 53: 657.—Hayes, H. T. Treatment of hemorrhoids by the injection of chemicals, a preliminary report. Texas J. M, 1926-27, 22: 247-52.—Heep, R. Hiimor- rhoidenverodung durch Varicocid. Zbl. Chir, 1934, 61: 3009-11.—\Huet, J. A. Traitement des hdmorroides par les injections coagulantes de glvcdrine phdniqude. Rev. gdn. clin. thdr, 1926, 40: 25-8.—Jameson, F. S. Newer method of treating hemorrhoids by the injection of 5 per cent phenol solution of oil. Med. Times, N. Y, 1930, 58: 329.—Kirschen, M. Die Behandlung der Hamorrhoiden mit Antiphlebin. Wien. med. Wschr, 1932, 82: 1576-8.—Kukine, N. K. [Treat- ment of hemorrhoid with sclerosing substances] Vest, khir, 1933, 31: 124-8.—Makhlin, E. U. [Hemorrhoids and new sclerotic treatment] Klin. J. Saratov. Univ., 1928, 6: 149-79.— Morley, A. S. The choice of solution for injection of hemor- rhoids. Clin. M. & S, 1935, 42: 292.—Panting, A. E. The quinine-urea treatment of haemorrhoids. Med. J. Australia, 1933, 2: 436-9.—Pazzagli, R. Sui risultati delle iniezioni sclerosanti di salicilato di sodio neUa cura delle emorroidi. Minerva med. Tor, 1930, 21: pt 2, 519-24.—Reuther, T. F, & Almquist, C. O. The injection treatment of hemorrhoids; results with a sodium psylliate solution. Illinois M. J, 1941, 79: 50-2.—Richter, W. Behandlung der Hamorrhoiden durch Verodung mit Chininldsungen. Med. Welt, 1932, 6: 1174.— Rolfe, W. A. The treatment of internal hemorrhoids with quinine and urea hydrochloride. N. England J. M, 1928-29, 198: 187.—Segard, M, & Siguret, G. Hdmorroides et injec- tions scldrosantes. Hopital, 1933, 21: 72-4.—Solution quinine and urea hydrochloride, 5% with procaine hydrochloride 2%, 30 cc. vials (Upjohn) not acceptable for N. N. R. J. Am. M. Ass, 1939, 113: 1415.—Tajes, V. Las inyeceiones esclerosantes en proctologfa. Arch. urug. med, 1935, 6: 345-52.—Ver- mehren, W. Beitrag zur konservativen Hamorrhoidalbe- handlung mit Recto-Serol. Zbl. inn. Med, 1929, 50: 289-91.— Zaun, H. Verodung der Hamorrhoiden durch Karbolglyzerin, Derm. Wschr, 1933, 97: 1320-4. ---- Treatment: Injection: Complication. Bensaude, R, & Bensaude, A. Les complications du traite- ment des hdmorroides par les injections scldrosantes. Clinique, Par, 1940, 35: 58.—Bohm, C. Injektionsbehandlung dei Hamorrhoiden und ihre KompUkationen. Med. Klin, Berl, 1938, 34: 361.—Drueck, C. J. After-care of sclerosing treat- ment of hemorrhoids. Med. Rec, N. Y, 1939, 150: 341-3.— Durand, G. Accidents de choc dans le traitement scldrosant des hemorroides. In Annde mdd. prat. Par, 1939, 18: 202.— Fansler, W. A. The injection treatment of hemorrhoids: some fallacies and complications. Minnesota M, 1932, 15: 98- 100.—Marshall, F. A. EmboUsm following hemorrhoidal injection. N. York State J. M, 1938, 38: 305.—Peyton, T. R. The menace of injection treatment of hemorrhoids. J. Nat. M. Ass, 1939, 31: 243-6.—Simmons, N. J. Anaphylaxis to sodium morrhuate following injection treatment of internal hemor- rhoids. N. England J. M, 1938, 218: 527.—Simonetti, G. B. E. Accidenti, esiti prossimi e lontani della cura delle emorroidi con le iniezioni sclerosanti. Arch. ital. chir, 1938, 48: 866. Cattan, R, & Bensaude, A. Accidenti, esiti prossimi e lontani della cura deUe emorroidi con le iniezioni sclerosanti. Arch. Soc. ital. chir. (1937) 1938, 44: 848-51. ---- Treatment: Injection: Instruments. Dalgleish, P. H. Proctoscope for injection of haemorrhoids. Brit. M. J, 1938, 1: 899.—Henning, N. Ueber eine neue Apparatur fur die Verodungs therapie der Hamorrhoiden. Deut. med. Wschr, 1936, 62: 457-60.—Hollander, E. A new procto- scope for the injection treatment of internal hemorrhoids. Med. J. & Rec, 1931, 133: 347.—Mikels, F. M. Safeguarded needle for hemorrhoidal injections. California West. M, 1934, 41: 45.—Miller, C. A discussion of Dr Quigley's article entitled a new instrument for the injection of hemorrhoides T. B. Quigley, M. D, Boston, Harvey Cushing feUow in surgery, Peter Bent Brigham Hospital. BuU. Off. Pract, 1935-36, 9: 101.—Montague, J. F. Rectoscope especiaUy designed for use HEMORRHOID o()S HEMORRHOID in the injection treatment of hemorrhoids. Internat. Clin, 1927, 37. ser, 1: 127-9, 2 pl. Oddn. C. L. A. An improved needle for the injection of internal hemorrhoids. J. Michigan M. Soc, 1940, 39: 101. Pitanga Santos, R. Im modelo de anuscopio e uma cannla simples para o tratamento das hemor- rhoidas pelas injeccoes esclerosantes. Fol. med, Rio, 1928, 9: 3*9-91. Also Rev. sudamdr. mdd. Par, 1930, 1: 61-6.— Quigley, T. B. A new instrument for the injection of hemor- rhoids. J. Am. M. Ass, 1935, 105: 1268. Also repr. ---- Treatment: Injection: Method. McXamara, T. F. Essentials of injection treatment of internal hemorrhoids. 117p. 8? Rochester, X. Y. [1934] Boas, I. Eine kleine, aber wichtige Verbesserung m einer Injektionsmethode der inneren Hamorrhoiden. Deut. med. Wschr, 1931, 57: 225.—Caldas, J. M. Um detalhe de technica no tratamento esclerosante das hemorrhoidas. Fol. med, Rio, 1937, 18: 271-3.—Crivelli, L. The Bensaude and Oury method of injecting haemorrhoids. Med. J. Australia, 1929, 2: 159.— Drueck, C. J. The treatment of hemorrhoids by dilatation and injection. Am. J. Surg, 1927, n. ser, 2: 579-84 Technic of injecting sclerosing solutions into hemorrhoids. Med. World, 1939, 57: 653-5.—Eisner, H. Die Radikalbe- handlung der Hamorrhoiden durch einmalige Injektion. Zbl. Gyn, 1931, 55: 2227.—Glaser, A. Schmerzlose Verodung von Hamorrhoiden in einer Sitzung beim ambulanten Patienten. Med. Klin, Berl, 1931, 27: 1245. Also Verh. Berl. med. Ges. (1931) 1932, 62: T. 2, 181-4—Hillemand, P, & Gaube, R. Le traitement des hdmorroides par iujeetions scldrosantes sus- hdmorroidaires. BuU. gin. thdr, 1937, 188: 3-9. Also in Thdr. mdd. actual. Par. (,1937) 1938, 4: 3-9.— Jeanneney, G. La mdthode scldrosante dans les andmies d'origine hdmor- roidaire. J. mdd. Bordeaux, 1933, 110: 193.—Lutier, A. Nouvelles formules et nouveUe technique pour le traitement des hdmorroides par les injections sclero-antes. Monaco mediter mdd, 1940, 7: 9-12.—Lyburn, E. F. St J. Application of pressure in the injection treatment of hacmorroids and pro- lapsus ani. Lancet, Lond, 1938, 1: 141.—Morley, A. S. An improved technique for the treatment of internal hremorrhoids by injection. Ibid, 1028, 1: 543-5.—Muller, O. Zur Injek- tionsbehandlimg von Hamorrhoiden. Med. Klin, Beil, 1935 31: ISC. -Schur, H. Neuerungen in der Technik der Hamor- rhonleiiverodiing. Wien. klin. Wsehr, 1930, 49: 427-9.— Spiesman, M. G. The injection treatment of hemorrhoids and rectal prolapse (an improved technic) Clin M & S 19»9 36:547-52. ....."'' ---- Treatment: Injection: Results. Bellot, V. J. Traitement scldrosant en une sdance des hdmor- roides; resultats d'une expdrience do 5 ans. Arch, mdd pharm nav, 1928, 118: 237-84. ■-----• Traitement sclerosant en une sdance des hdmorroides; rdsultats d'une expdrience de 6 ans Presse mdd, 1929, 37: 1328-31.—Bensaude, R, & Oury 1»' Traitement des hdmorroides par les injections scldrosanW 7 ans d expdrience. Ibid, 1928, 36: 700-11.—Blanchard, C. E The evolution of the injection treatment for internal hemor- rhoids Bull. Off. Pract, 1938-39, 12: 78-87.—Boas, I. Ueber zehnjahnge Erfahrungen mit meiner Methode der Hamor- rhoidalbehandlung. Deut. med. Wsehr, 1927 53- 519-21 Also Klin. Wschr, 1927, 6: 424.—Caldas, J. M. Sobre 5 980 injeccoes esclerosantes no tratamento das hemorrhoidas Brasil med, 1940, 54: 671-4.—Connors, R. J. A critique of the injection treatment of hemorrhoids. Med. Rec N Y 1934 140: 8.—Ebner, E. Ueber dreijiihrige Erfah'rung mit der Injekuoi^heliandlung der Hamorrhoiden an der II. Chirur- gischen Klmik. Wien. kUn. Wschr, 1935, 48: 1088-92 — Pansier, V> A. A critical study of the injection treatment'of hemorrhoids. J Lancet, 1927, 47: 524-7.—Filderman, L. Les injections scldrosantes a la portde de tous les praticiens. Bull. soc. mdd. Paris, 1939-40, 93-7.—Hayes, H T The treatment of hemorrhoids with injection and surgerv * Texas J. M., 1933. 29: 340-3 -Henninger, H. ForLhritte de Hamorrhoideii-Ii,jektio,i,behaiidlung. Wien. kUn. Wschr. 1366 4b: _, 0-2.------Erfahrungen mit der Hamorrhoideu- InjektiOM-Behandl.mg. Ibid, 1934, 47: 941-3.-Junghann3, H. IJeber Lrlahrungen bei der Behandlung der Hamorrhoiden durch Einspntzungen. Arch. kUn. Chir, 1933-34 178- 383- 99 —Kleiner S. B. The development of the injection treatment of hemorrhoids Yale J. Biol 1930-31, 3: 49-57.—McNamaw I. t. Hemorrhoids; its radical operation and the injection treatment J. Am. Coll. Proct 1933-34, 6: 35.-Manhein" S. D, & Druckerman, L J. The limitations of the injection treatment of hemorrhoids. N. York State J. M 1939 30" 1473.-Mar.no, AW M, & Turell, R. The treatment of internal hemorrhoids by injection; a study based on observa uons of 5,000 injections Brooklyn Hosp. J, 1939, 1-93-8- Pincus \\ . Meme Erfahrungen mit der Boasschen lnjektions- logf-p'rJit'' 'm Torri1ioh-en;- L)e,!t- ?ed- Wschr- 192K: ,„oiV, , V- • ^cations, technic, and comparative treatment of hemorrhoids, with a resumd of 115 cases Hos^ News, Wash., 1930, 3: No. 10, 1-15 —Rickert C M RoTP 1 cure of hemoirhoids by the injection mfSoa^cLKsioSft'om fiLev W ^peTLence' . A?- Physician, 1926, 31: 141-3- R«e>. W \\ Hemorrhoids; injection or operation. Virginia M. Month, 1927-28, 54: 434-6.—Robinson, I, F. The present status of the injection treatment of internal hemorrhoids J Florida M. Ass, 1931, 18: 215-20.—Sacks. G. Notes on' il,u* injection tieatment of internal haemorrhoids. Brit. M. J 1933, 1:313. Teachnor, W. Facts about the injeclion method of treating hemorrhoids. Ohio M. .1, 1932, 28: 437 I ' - Vogel, F. Ueber die Injektionsbehandlune von Hiimoi, |,,,i. dalknoten. Wien. klin. W.M-hr, 1935, 48: 872-4.—Woojf, M. s. Injection treatment for hemorrhoids; a review of 5 000 iniVe' tions. Med. World, 1938, 56: 303-6. ---- Treatment: Method. Guernsey, YV. J. Homoeopathic therapeutics of haemorrhoids. 2. ed. 142p. 8? Phila., 1X92. Alfredo, J. Tratamento nao cirurgicos das hemorroidis Brasil med, 1929, 43: 1073-0.—Bartsch-Dunne. A. The conservative treatment of hemorrhoids. Med. Woman I 1930, 37: 246-52.—Bertwistle, A. P. Cholagogues in the trea£ ment of haemorrhoids. Clin. J, Lond, 1941, 70: 155 — Brooke, B. R. The nonsurgical treatment of piles; a simple office procedure. Northwest M, 1931, 30: 32.—Campbell, F. B Hemorrhoids: evaluation of various methods of treatment Month. BuU. Kansas City CUn. Soc, 1935, 11: 8.—Cardoner Planas, A. El tratamiento no cruento de las hemorroides Rev. mdd. Barcelona, 1935, 23: 325-36.—Chabreyroux. Les vaccinations locales; leur application au traitement des hdmor- roides et des metrites. Bruxelles mdd, 1934-35, 15: 916-8.__ Crookall, A. Hemorrhoids: some remarks on their treatment Northwest M , 1927, 26: 453-7.—Eisner. H. Die nichtopera- tive Radikalbehandlung der Hamorrhoiden. Klin. Wschr 1931, 10: 1032-4.—Fantozzi, G. Un metodo per trat tare le emorroidi. Rass. internaz. clin. ter, 1930, 11: 700.—Fatrai, F [Recent_ treatment of hemorrhoids] Gyogyilszat, 1935, 75 S 187.—Filippi, M. Hautes doses mddicamenteuses dans la'crise hdmorroidaire aigue. Arch. mal. app. digest. Par, 1939, 29: 788-94.------ Discussions soulevdes par la diversitd dis traitements anti-hdmorroidaires. Echo mdd. nord, 1939 3 ser, 10: 485-91.—Fonseca, F. Procedimiento no'sangrante para la cxtirpacion de hemorroides. Rev. mex. cir. gin. c&neer 1934, 2: 487-90.—Baines, J. J. The ambulant treatment of haemorrhoids. J. Missouri M. Ass., 1927, 21: 08-70.—Gronau. Die kausale Therapie der Hriniorrhoidnlerkrankuno'en Deut' med Wschr, 1926, 52: 1.55S. -Gross, I, Hamonhoidenbc- handlung ohne Operation. Perl. Klin, 1926, H 359 1-46 — Guild, W. A. Physical palliation of piles. J. Am. Inst. Homeop , 1935, 28: 92.—Guy, W. B. The treat,.rent of hemorrhoids with hydrochloric acid. Med. World, 1936, 54: 385—Hahn <) Zur Therapie der Hamorrhoiden und Analfissuren. Deut med Wschr 1928, 54: 1091.—Hoff. A. Die naturgemasse Behand- lung der Hamorrhoiden. Naturiirztl. Rdsch, 1939 11: 111- 8 —Horwitz, E. Beitrag zur Behandlung der Hamorrhoiden Ther. Gegenwart, 1926, 67: 139.—Koch, R. Ueber die Behand- lung von Colitis und Hamorrhoiden mit Levurinose. Fortsch Ther, 1928 4: 126.—Kretschmer, A. Zur Behandlung von Hamorrhoiden. Deut. med. Wschr, 1936, 62: 1266.—Makhlin. EV r[ o Berlsal'de's method in the tieatment of hemorrhoids] Khn J. Saratov. Univ., 1928, 5: 93-101—Mauerer, A. Beitrag wT i ,apoe,von Hamorrhoiden und Pruritus ani. Deut. med. Wschr, 1933, 59: 1363.—Montague, J. F. PreUminary report %a a jew treatment of hemorrhoids. Tr. Am. Proct. Soc, 1926, £°.: 82_?-T;Mulle!;. «• Zur konservativen Behandlung der Hamorrhoiden. Med. Welt, 1932, 6: 417.—Norbury, L. K. C. £?miLp0mAS,ln -the treatment of piles. Clin. J, Lond, 1931, 60: ?i, -a11 c 5,n' \' K" lAmbulatory treatment of hemor- rhoids] Sovet. med, 1940, 4: No. 20, 34.—Osborn, W. M. A method ysdivulsion. Tr. Am. Coll. Proct, 1931, 8: 169-71, h»™ " i • ! ^ ^ ^ The nonsurgical method of treating hemorrhoids. Bull. Off. Pract, 1936-37, 10: 155-9.-RacheC ™k 1 ^^^miento curativo de las hemorroides por los mdtodos amDuiatonos. Cr6n. mdd. mex, 1933, 32: 157-62—Ratti, L. v\ ,oKutlc c,hair for hemorrhoids. U. S. Patent Off, 1941, i,atw 1 j , I"8" A* A1SUIlas consideraciones sobre el 1 £orgfeal treatment of hemorrhoids. Memphis M. m'pntTf I u~ZScanHeton' J- M- The ambulatory treat- ment of hemorrhoids. Wisconsin M. J, 1934, 33: 114-9.- nnThl,re'\ir .hemorrhoidal varices and their treatment based ^h^,aU^°ruexpenPncel Warsz- czas- ^k, 1938, 15: 8-22.- r£w n Hamorrhoiden, ihre Entstehung und biochemische Behandlung. Mitt. Biochem, Lage, 1935, 42: 193-5.- P?,ri°n1a",n: , .*!?g zur Behandlung der Hammorrhoiden. Fort,ch. 1 her 1927, 3: 203-6.—Stahl. O. Die Saugbehandlung m>m 1 °rrh0,dea-T Ueut- mcd- VVschr., 1933, 5J: 1402 [liemerkurisen von I Boas] 1049,-Stanton, F. D. Helpful h its J. Am. ColL Proct, 1933-34, 6: 312-5.-Sultan, G. m» 1 w P d?r B°asschen Hamorrhoidalbehandlung. Deut. med. Wschr, 1927, 53: 927.-Szego, K. Die aktive Hehandlung der Hamorrhoiden; Defluxion von Stauungen. Wien. med. of horm' Su-17'- 9'f-7.-«zekely, I. [Conservative treatment 01 Hemorrhoids and their compUcations] Gy6gyaszat, 1934, ,i.A;h 'Tr "ell\^' "• Selecting the treatment for hemor- iiJT? *£• AIoulh- W3I, 58: 504-7. Also repr.- t rommsdorfl, R Zur symptomatischen Therapie der Hamor- rhoiden. Aerztl. Rdsch, 1927, 37: 12-4.—Lnger, H. Zur Iherapie der Hamorrhoiden. Munch, med. Wschr, 1929, 76: 103/. vance, D. D. The non-operative treatment of hemor- HEMORRHOID 569 HEMOSIDERIN rhoids. Virginia M. Month, 1934, 61: 160-3.—Weichherz, I. [Conservative treatment of hemorrhoids] Budapesti orv. ujs, 1934, 32: 541.—Zorraquin, G. Hemorroides; su concepto clinico terapdutico. Rev. mdd. lat. amer, B. Air, 1932-33, 18: 1396-407. .---• Treatment: Ointments, salves, and sup- positories. Bereziner, A. [Hemorrhoids cured with anaesthesin- dermatol salve] Vrach. gaz, 1927, 31: 1822.—Demitry, A. Su di una pomata awerso l'emmorroidi esterne. Filiatre sebezio, Nap, 1838, 15: 398.—Dufour, H. Le tanin dans les hdmorroides. CUnique, Par, 1940, 35: 58.—Gagliardi, A. Sulla gelatina emostatica nella pratica medica. Terapia Milano, 1925, 15: 379-82.—Goldberger. Dumex-Salbe und Dumex-Ovale fiir die Veterinarmedizin. Berl. tierarztl. Wschr, 1929, 45: 58.—Grolnick, M. Dermatitis due to hemorrhoidal ointment containing krameria and oil of cade. J. Am. M. Ass, 1938, 110: 951.—Heim, W. Philonin-Zapfchen fur die Behand- lung von Hamorrhoiden. Miinch. med. Wschr, 1934, 81: 2007.—Heinen, H. Die Behandlung von Haemorrhoidal- erkrankungen mit Xylidrin. Med. Welt, 1938, 12: 860.— Henius, M. Zur Behandlung der Hamorrhoiden mit Sipon- suppositorien. Ther. Gegenwart, 1926, 67: 92.—Ives wonder pile remedy. J. Am. M. Ass, 1941, 117: 879.—Kowalzig, H. Zur Hamorrhoidalbehandlung mit Nohiisa. Aerztl. Rdsch, 1930, 40: 144.—Kuczynski. Haemoricet-Ziipfchen, ein neueres Mittel zur Behandlung von Hamorrhoiden. Ther. Gegenwart, 1938, 79: 380.—Lyburn, E. F. S. The appUcation of astringents on a rectal plug in the treatment of haemorrhoids. Lancet, Lond, 1938, 2: 234.— Milbradt, W. Beobachtungen und Erfahrungen mit einem neuen Hamorrhoidalzapfchen, Asbu Fortsch. Ther, 1939, 15: 360-2.—Osterweil, W. Ueber Be- handlung der Hamorrhoiden mit Anusol-Suppositorien. Med. Klin, Berl, 1927, 23: 1225.—Piedallu, P. [Adrepatine in rational medical treatment of hemorrhoides] Cluj. med, 1933, 14: 639.—Preuss, H. Ueber Erfahrungen mit Ichtoxylsup- positorien bei HaemorrhoidaUeiden. Fortsch. Ther, 1929, 5: 253-5.—Ritter & Timmermann. Anichthol-Ichthyol-Hell- Analzapfchen und Hamorrhoidal-Salbe. Deut. med. Wschr, 1937, 63: 1561.—Schwarz, B. Erfahrungen mit Phnonin Ziipfchen. Ibid, 1934, 60: 1962.—Vapor-gas; a new and marvelous discovery for piles essentially a mixture of com- mercial sodium hydroxide and commercial gelatin. J. Am. M. Ass, 1936, 107: 1488.—Van Vleck nostrums. Ibid, 1941, 117: 472.—Wachtel, H. Ueber die Anwendung eines neuen Hamor- rhoidalmittels in der Geburtshilfe. Schweiz. med. Wschr, 1936, 66: 1060. --- Treatment: Physiotherapy. Marchand. J. H. Les agents phvsiques dans le traitement des hdmorroides. Bull. gdn. thdr, 1937, 188: 22-31. Also In Thdr. mdd. actual. Par. (1937) 1938, 4: 22-31.—Seeuwen. Le traitement des hdmorrhoides ct des fissures sphinctdralgiques Ann. dlectrob, Lille, 1906, 9: 626-9.—Yamamura, Y. Radium irradiation for treatment of the hemorrhoids. Jap. J. M. Sc, 1934-36, 4: Surg. &c, 282.—Zhavoronkov, I. N. [Therapeutic exercises in hemorrhoids] KUn. med, Moskva, 1940, 18: No. 12, 90-4. --- in animals. K oh ler. Ueber einen Fall von Hamorrhoiden bei einem Pferde. Zschr. Veteriniirk, 1932, 44: 246. --- in childhood. Bensaude, A, & Bertillon, F. Hdmorroides et angiomes ano- rectaux chez l'enfant. Arch. mal. app. digest. Par, 1938, 28: 181-97. Also in MaL intestin (R. Bensaude) Par, 1939, 4: 208-22.—Cohen, N. Hamorrhoiden im Kindesalter; schwere sekundare Anamie infolge chronischer Hamorrhoidalblutungen. Ausz. Inaugur. Diss. Med. Fak. Univ. Bern (1935-37) 1938, No. 82, 1-3.—Durand, G. Hdmorroides chez l'enfant. In Annee mdd. prat. Par, 1939, 18: 203.—Sperling. V. Ueber Hamorrhoidenknoten beim Neugeborenen nach Steissgeburten. Arch. Kinderh, 1932, 97: 104. HEMORRHOIDAL plexus. For nerves and veins see Rectum. HEMOSIDERIN. See also Hemochromatosis; Hemosiderosis cutis. Michel, E. [E. G.] *Haemosiderin in Milz und Leber von Laboratoriumstieren [Leipzig] 40p. 8? Lucka, 1925. Schtjltze, K. W. *Zur Chemie des Haemo- siderins. p. 101-12. 8? Freib., 1931. Also Beitr. path. Anat, 1931, 86: Wolf, E. *Histochemische Untersuchungen iiber das Vorkommen eisenhaltigen Pigments (Hamosiderin) in der Milz und Leber der Haus- siiugetiere unter normalen Verhaltnissen [Leip- zig] 7p. 8? [Lommatzsch] 1923. T T9.°?k^S- F* Tne structure and composition of hemosiderin. J. Biol. Chem, 1929, 82: 595-609.—Lillie, R. D. The solubiUfy of hemosiderin in various reagents during and after various fixations. J. Techn. Meth, Toronto, 1938, 18: 82. ------■ Experiments on the solubility of hemosiderin in acids and other reagents during and after various fixations. Am. J. Path, 1939 15: 225-39—Ziegler, M., & Wolf, E. Histochemische Unter- suchungen iiber das Vorkommen eisenhaltigen Pigments (Hamosiderins) in der Milz und Leber der Haussaugetiere unter normalen und einigen pathologischen Verhaltnissen. Virchows Arch, 1924, 249: 374-99. HEMOSIDEROSIS. See Hemochromatosis. HEMOSIDEROSIS cutis. See also Dermatosis, pigmentary progressive; Hemochromatosis. Diss, M. Les hdmosiddroses cutandes. Strasbourg mdd 1930, 90: 127; 207; 229.—Gate, J., & Delbos, J. Un cas d'hdmosiddrose cutande essentieUe chez un jeune. Bull. Soc fr. derm, syph, 1938, 45: 1447-9.—Sannicandro, G. Le emosiderosi cutanee. Arch. ital. derm, sif, 1934, 10: 133-90.— Sei lei, J. [Localization and progression of hemosiderosis] Orv. hetil, 1929, 73: 232-5. Also Arch. Derm. Syph, 1929, 157: 517-22.------• Ueber die Haemosiderosis racemosa (reticularis) progrediens alter Leute. Derm. Wschr, 1932, 95: 1125. ------ L'hdmosiderose rdticulaire progressive type Schamberg. Rev. fr. derm, vdndr, 1935, 11: 385-9. HEMOSTASIS. See also Blood coagulation; Hemorrhage, Treatment; Hemostatic. Harvey, S. C. The history of hemostasia. 128p. 8? N. Y., 1929. Also Ann. M. Hist, 1929, n. ser, 1: 127-54. Breitner, B. Blutstillung und Blutersatz. Miinch. med. Wschr, 1934, 81: 271-3.—Delfino, E. A. Historia de la hemo- stasia y la sincronizacion de Bosch Arana. Sem. mdd, B. Air, 1939, 46: pt 2, 481-92.—Stich. Blutung, Blutstillung und Blutungsverhutung. Zbl. Chir, 1930, 57: 1484-7.—Stuber, B. Neuere Ansichten fiber das Wesen der Blutgerinnung und deren praktische Verwertung fiir die interne Therapie der Blutung. Prakt. Arzt, 1917, 57: 1; 27.—Zimmer, H. Kritiscbe Sammelreferat iiber Hamostypsis. Deut. med. Wschr.. 1925, 51:45; 85. ---- Mechanism, Frenzel, W. Das Ratsel der Blutstillung. Umschau, 193 6j 40: 284.—Gramenitsky, M. I. [Mechanism of checking hemor- rhage] J. Physiol. USSR, 1937, 22: 901-6.—Hekma, E. [Blood coagulation] Geneesk. bl, 1937, 34: 257-300 — Lenggenhager, K. Das Wunder der spontanen Blutstillung. Munch, med. Wschr, 1935, 82: 2067-70. ------ Blut- gerinnung und Blutstillung. Praxis, Bern, 1936, 25: 208-10.— Mills, C. A. Blood coagulation and the control of hemorrhage; theories of blood clotting. J. Orient. M, Dairen, 1928, 8: 58; 89.—Morawitz, P. Mechanismen der BlutstiUung. Deut. med. Wschr, 1926, 52: 1371-3. Also KUn. Wschr, 1926, 5: 1853. Also Munch, med. Wschr, 1926, 73: 1463.—Roskam, J. Introduction k l'etude physiologique de l'hdmostase spontanee. Arch, internat. physiol, Lidge, 1938, 47: 325-44. Also Sang, Par, 1939, 13: 225-40. ------& Pauwen, L. Une technique et une mdthode pour l'dtude de l'hdmostase spontande et des mddications hdmostatiques. Arch, internat. pharm. dyn. Par, 1937, 57: 450-66.—Schiirer, F. Neuere Ansichten iiber Blutgerinnung und Blutstillung. Wien. klin. Wschr, 1938, 51: 453-6.—Schultz, W. Die Untersuchungsmethoden der Blutgerinnung und der Blutgefassfunktion in ihrer Beziehung zur Blutstillungsfrage. In Handb. allg. Hamat. (Hirschfeld) Berl, 1933, 2: 1. Halfte, 645-700.—Schumann, E. A. Newer concepts of blood coagulation and the control of hemorrhage. Tr. Am. Gyn. Soc. (1939) 1940, 64: 73-8. Also Am. J. Obst, 1939, 38: 1002-7.—Steinberg, A, & Brown, W. R. A new concept regarding the mechanism of clotting and the control of hemorrhage. Am. J. Physiol, 1939, 126: 638.—Tannenberg, J. Der Mechanismus der spontanen Blutstillung. Verh. Deut. path. Ges, 1927, 22: 301-4. ------ & Herrmann. Experimentelle Untersuchungen iiber den Mechanismus der spontanen Blutstillung. Arch. klin. Chir, 1927, 147: 721-9. ---- Method. Richault, P. *Le principe vaso-constricteur du genet utilise comme h6mostatique en sto- matologic 46p. 8? Par., 1928. HEMOSTASIS 570 HEMOSTASIS Zimmermann, M. *Methodik dor Blut- stillung mit besonderer Berucksichtigung klini- scher Beobachtungen des neuen Blutstillungs- priiparates. 35p. 22cm. Rostock, 1936. Anguera de Sojo. El tratamiento sintomatico de las hemo- rragias en medicina prActica. Arch, med, Madr, 1926, 22: 408-13.—Binet, L, & Strurhza, M. V. Le traitement d'extrdme urgence des hdmorragies suraigues. Bull. Acad, mdd. Par, 1940, 3. sdr, 123: 223-7.—Brown, R. C. The general principles in the treatment of hemorrhage as appUed to obstetrics. Med. Of!., Lond, 1931, 46: 36-7.—Browne, O. Shock foUowing blood extravasation with special reference to the treatment of accidental haemorrhage. Brit. M. J, 1931, 2: 1124-7.— Bulmer. E. CUnical features, investigation and treatment of haemorrhage in its various forms. Med. Press & Circ, Lond, 1940, 204: 4-8.—Canestro, C. Le procedd d'hdmostase de Momburg et les capsules snrrdnales. Rev. chir. Par, 1011, 44: 903-15. Also Clin, mod, Zaragoza, 1912, 11: 4-1.">. Cone, A. J. Use of salt pork in cases of hemorrhage. Tr. Am. Lar. Rhin. Otol. Soc, 1940, 46: 133-41.—Control (The) of hemor- rhage; when excessive bleeding can be anticipated, or is in progress, it is often worthwhUe to shorten coagulation time. Ther. Notes, Detr, 1938, 45: 277-9.— Denecke. Schwer stillbare Blutung. Munch, med. Wschr, 1931, 78: 1946.— Goglia, G. Terapia dells emorragie da infezioni. Rinasc. med, 1940, 17: 138-41.—Gorecki, Z. [Treatment of hemor- rhages; nature of hemorrhage, methods of cUnical investigations and their importance] Lek. wojsk, 1939, 33: 385-410.— Guiou, N. M. Haemorrhage at the outposts. Canad. M. Ass. J, 1930, 23: 679-81. Also repr.—Hoitink, A. W. J. H. Treat- ment of the acute fatal haemorrhage. Acta brevia neerl, 1935, 5: 4. Also Ned. tschr. geneesk, 1935, 79: 1158-61.— Huggett, A. St. G, Davidson, M. [et al.] Discussion on thera- peutic methods of arresting haemorrhage. Proc. R. Soc. M, Lond, 1936-37, 30: 645-52.—[Instruction for checking hemor- rhages] Sovet. med, 1940, No. 10, 32-4.—Jellett, H. The treatment of unavoidable haemorrhage. N. Zealand M. J, 1927-28, 26: 71-6.—Kleinschmidt, <). Ueber die Stillung von Blutungen aus Kdrperoffnungen. Deut. med. Wsehr, 1931, 57: 1629; 1670.—Krisch, W. Biolosische Blutstillung durch Aderlass. Med. Welt, 1935, 9: 1179.—Lee, E. S. The first- aid control of haemorrhage. Med. Press & Circ, Lond, 1941, 205: 83-5.—Litchfield, J. W. Haemorrhage and its first aid treatment. Nurs. Times, Lond, 1939, 35: 318; 358.—Littell, J. J. An effective method of controUing secondary hemorrhage. Laryngoscope, 1932, 42: 207-9.—Logothetopulos, K. Ueber meine Bhitstillungsmethodc. Zbl. Gyn, 1931, 55: 102; 2355.—Lopez, V. Der Einfluss verschiedener Behandlungs- methoden auf die Blutstillung. Arch. klin. Chir, 1931, 165: 375-82.—Louros, N. Ueber eine sogenannte absolut sichere Blutstillungsinclhode. Zbl. Gyn, 1931, 55: 1332-5.— Mills, C. A. Hemorrhages, their significance and methods of treat- ment. Am. J. M. Sc, 1926, 172: 71-80. Also repr. Also J. Orient. M, Dairen, 1928, 9: 1-10.—Mohrardt, P. E. Les proeddds de tdldhdmostase et d'hdmostase locale. Vie mdd, 1925, 16: 759-63. ---- Method, physical. Pohl, W. *Ergebnisse der Milzbestrahlung zur sofortigen Blutstillung bei gynakologischen Erkrankungen [Wurzburg] 61p. 21cm. Berl., 1936. Brunetti, F, & Cebba, I. L'impiego dei raggi X a scopo emostatico in O. R. L. Atti Congr. ital. radiol, 1934, 11: pt 2. 373.—Howat, R. K. Elevation in the immediate treat- ment of severe haemorrhage and shock. Brit. M. J, 1940, 2: 65.—Kaufmann, A. [X-ray irradiation of spleen in treatment of hemorrhage] Gyogyaszat, 1934, 74: 395.—Mertz, E. Zur Frage der Blutstillung durch Milzbestrahlung. Zschr. Ge- burtsh. Gyn, 1927-28, 92: 544-65.—Probst, V. Zur Strahlen- behandlung gutartiger Blutungen. Zbl. Gyn, 1938, 62: 147-50.—Roskam, J. La thdrapeutique des hdmorragies par le chaud et le froid est-eUe iustifide? Liege mdd, 1933, 26: 1385-408.------Peut-on recourir k la chaleur et au froid dans le traitement des hdmorragies? In Libro de oro M R ('astex, B. Air, 1939, 3: 1757-65.—Stoker, S. B. Effect of heat and cold on haemorrhage. Brit. M. J, 1939, 2: 1185. ---- Military aspect. See also War injury. Baldwin, J. F. The Detmold method of controUing in- operable hemorrhage; a forgotten, but occasionaUy invaluable procedure. Am. J. Surg, 1932, n. ser, 17: 279-80. Also Mil. Surgeon, 1933, 72: 34-6.—Caccia, F, & Casella, D. Metodi di emostasia sul campo di battaglia: unificazione dei materiale di primo soccorso e modaUti della sua applicazione Congr. internat. mdd. pharm. md, 1931, 6. Congr, 1: 309-45.— Constant, G. Blutstillung und Blutersatz in einer Geb Divi- sion. Schweiz. med. Wschr, 1940, 70: 855-7.—Decker, P. L'hdmostase d'urgence en chirurgie de guerre. Helvet med acta, 1941, 8: 3-21.—Methods of hemostasis on the battle- field: standardization of first-aid material and the mode of appUcation. Congr. internaz. med. farm, mil, 1933 7 Congr pt 6, 95-110.—Mirotvortsev, S. R., & Golkin, M B [Ex- perience with checking hemorrhages from parenchymatous organs during peace ami in wartime] Sovet. med, 1941, 5: No. 15, 8-10.—Molitor, H. Blutstillung und Blutersatz Wien. klin. Wschr, 1928, II: 387-9. Normet, L. Le traite- ment des hdmorragies et des dtats de choc traumatique aux amides de -juerre. Bruxelles mdd, 1938-39, 19: 1474-S2.— Praag, S. W. Les proeddds d'hdmostase du champ de bataille; unification du matdriel de premidre urgence et des conditions de son application. Congr. internat. mdd. pharm. mil, 1931, 6. Congr, 1: 290-308.—Quick. A. J. Contribution of tho laboratory to the treatment of hemorrhage. Illinois M. J, 1941, 79: 346-9.—Roskam, J. Nouvelles considdrations sur la thdrapeutique hdmostatique. Echo mdd. nord, 1934, .'i. ser, 2: 338-51. ------ Que penser du traitement mddicrd des hdmorragies? Bruxelles mdd, 1934-35, 15: 532-4.—Sanchez Gomez, J. Les proeddds d'hdmostase du champ* de bataille (systdme original du Dr Sanchez G6mez de ligatures auto- matiques, mdtalUques, rdabsorbables des vaisseaux) Congr. internaz. med. pharm. mil, 1931, 6. Congr, 2: 161.----- Aportaci6n original al tratamiento de urgencia en las hemo- rragias. Ibid, 1933, 7. Congr, 2: tema 3, 89-91.— Scott, L. D. W. Observations on the treatment of severe haemate- mesis and melaena. Edinburgh M. J, 1940, 47: 49-56.— Smidt, H. Das Verhalten des praktischen Arztes bei akuten Blutungen. Fortsch. Ther, 1927, 3: 12-5.—Stuhmer, A. Ueber einige moderne. Methoden medikamentoser Blut- stiUung. Fortsch. Med, 1912, 30: 353; 407.—Szecsi, B. [Determination of the duration of hemorrhage and its control] Orv. hetil, 1930, 74: 1109-13.—Therapeutic methods of arresting haemorrhage. Brit. M. J, 1936, 2: 1277. Also Lancet, Lond, 1936, 2: 1398-400.—Throndson, A. H. Can we control bleeding? Contact Point, 1936-37, 14: 136-9.— Tonkes, E. [Symptoms of sudden hemorrhage, measures adopted by the organism, and factors which should be borne in mind in treating it] Ned. tschr. verlosk, 1934, 37: 153- 292.—Tuohy, E. B. Control of bleeding. Proc. Mayo Clin, 1940, 15: 726-8.—Velden, R. von den. Ueber die Behandlung von Blutungen. Tungchi med. Mschr, 1938-39, 14: 149- 56.—Winters, V. M. E. Hdmostase sur le champ de bataille. Congr. internat. mdd. pharm. mil, 1931, 6. Congr, 2: 160-3.—• Wood, I. J. Treatment of haemorrhage. Brit. M. J, 1936, 2: 115-21. ---- Pathology. See also Hemorrhagic diathesis. Mills, C. A. Blood coagulation and the control of hemor- rhage; variation in the blood coagulability: physiological, pathological and experimental. J. Orient. M, Dairen, 1928, 8: 105-14.—Roskam. Le mdcanisme de l'hdmostase spontande et ses troubles. BuU. Acad. mdd. Belgique, 1931, 5. ser, 11: 541-80. ---- surgical. See also such headings as Blood vessels, Surgery: Ligation; Diathermy; Electrotherapy, &c. Busch, G. *Moderne Blutstillung in der Chirurgie. 32p. 22^cm. Greifsw., 1937. Mariani, J. N. *Hemostaticos cirurgicos. 21p. 8? Bahia, 1864. Adelmann, G. von. De la flexion forcde et permanente des membres comme moyen d'arrdter les hdmorragies traumatiques. Presse mdd. beige, 1868-69, 21: 45.—Bauer, K. H. Experi- mented und histologische Untersuchungen uber die Blutstil- lung mit Hochfrequenzstrom. Arch. klin. Chir, 193Q, 162: 325-8 [Discussion] 17-22. Also Zbl. Chir, 1930, 57: 1487. ------ Die elektrische Blutstillung, ihr Mechanismus und dessen Erklarung. Arch. khn. Chir, 1930-31, 163: 564-90 — Berger. BlutstiUung durch Fingerdruck in der Wunde? Med. Welt, 1931, 5: 232.—Block, W. Zur Behandlung von Organ- und Sickerblutungen. Arch. klin. Chir, 1936, 186: 205-11 [Discussion] 40.—Champy, C, & Heitz-Boyer, M. Sur Taction hdmostatique du bistouri dlectrique. C. rend. Soc. biol, 1930, 103: 385-7.—Chevallier, P., & Bloch, L. L'hdmostase chirur- gicale. Sem. hop. Paris, 1931, 7: 172-7.—Cospedal. Sobre la importancia en el curso de las operaciones de las anemias por hemorragias. Actas Congr. espan. obst. gin. pediat, 1911, 2. Congr, 390-3.—Divella, D. Emostasi degU organi parenchima- tosi; ricerche sperimentaU. Riv. chir, 1939, 5: 251-67.— Dobkowsky, T. Ueber die medikamentose Stillung von Nach- blutungen in der Zahnheilkunde. Zschr. Stomat, 1930, 28: 89.5-905.—Domanig, E. Zur Blutstillung in der Operalious- wunde. Zbl. Chir, 1935, 62: 549-51—Florcken, H. Zur Frage der Blutstillung bei chirurgischen Operationen. Ibid, 1938, 65: 2587-91.—Fonio, A. Die Bestimmung der Prognose der BlutstiUung. Arch. kUn. Chir, 1928, 152: 459-76. [Dis- cussion] 97; 103.—Hesse, E. It. [Errors, dangers and unfore- seen complications in checking hemorrhage] In Oshibki &c. lech. khir. zabol. (Hesse, E. R. [et al.]) 1936, 1: 299.—Lilienthal, H. The control of inaccessible hemorrhage. Am. J. Surg, 1933, 22: 476. Also repr.—Moure, P. L'hdmostase des vais- seaux par dlectro-coagulation diathermique sur pince. Bull. Soc. nat. chir. Par, 1933, 59: 78-88.—Newell, C. H. The value of sequestration anemia in surgery. Nebraska M. J, 1934, 19: 384-7.—Norrlin, L. [Artificial blood checking in the skin and HEMOSTASIS 57 subcutaneous tissues is generally unnecessary in regular operations] Sven. lak. tidn, 1934, 31: 951-3— Pignatti, A. L'emostasi negh organi parenchimatosi dell'addome a mezzo di trapianti liberi di tessuti. PoUclinico, 1915, 22: sez. chir, 1- 23.—Sagarra y Lascurain, V. Sinemapria; nuevo procedi- miento de didresis hemostitica para la divisi6n de las partes Wandas. Congr. hisp. portug. cirug, 1898, 1. Congr, 77-92.— Stich, R. Blutung, Blutstillung und Blutungsverhiitung. Arch. kUn. Chir, 1930, 162: 279-324 [Discussion] 17.—Zenker. Blutstillung in der Chirurgie. Umschau, 1941, 45: 145-7. ---- surgical: Instruments. Cubero Otoya, G. *Zur Technik der Blut- stillung unter Berucksichtigung einer neuen Arterienklemme. 31p. 8? [Bonn] 1928. Schtjttemeyer, W. *Ueber die sogenannten Arterienabbinder zur Umschniirung blutender Gliedmassen [Berlin] 22p. 21cm. Rheine, 1937. Adson, A. W, & Fincher, E. F, jr. Hemostatic scalp clip. J. Am. M. Ass, 1933, 101: 276-8.—Arnaud, L. Garrot pneuma- tique pour l'hdmostase des membres. P. verb. Congr. fr. chir, 1938, 47. Congr, 611-3.—Blau.O. Zur ersten Hilfe bei schweren Blutungen: vereinfachte Notaderpresse mit einem Isthmus. Mschr. UnfallheUk, 1931, 38: 450-7.—Cornish, R. E. Hemor- rhage arrester. U. S. Patent Off, 1939, No. 2,163,588 — Gardonyi, J. [New hemostatic arm bandage] Orv. hetil, 1937, 81: meU, 83.—Haase, W, & Schiitterneyer, W. Brauchbare und unbrauchbare Hilfsmittel zur Abschniirung blutender GUedmassen. Arch, orthop. UnfaUchir, 1937-38, 38: 493-7.— Heller, J. Erfahrungen mit einem neuen, leieht (in der Tasche) tragbaren, sicher wirkenden von mir konstruirten automatischen Aorta-Compressor. Handel. Internat. congr. verlosk, 1938, 7. Congr, 2: 184.—Hofhauser, J. [Forceps for hemostatic clamps] Orv. hetil, 1937, 81: 1202.—Khaskelevich, M. G, [Blood-checking tube] Vrach. delo, 1941, 23: 141.—Kirillov, M. N. [Checking of hemorrhage of the extremities in horses with the aid of paraffin dressing] Sovet. vet, 1939, 16: 109.— Kokoris, D. Zur BlutstiUungsfrage; BlutstUlung feuchten Tupfern. Zbl. Chir, 1936, 63: 872-4.—Leo, C. Su di un bracciale pneumatico per l'emostasi preventiva. Arch. ital. chir, 1931-32, 29: 466-8. —---- DeU'emostasi preventiva in chirurgia ed in particolare di un nuovo apparecchio per ottenerla. Ibid, 30: 469-510.—Leone, P. Su di una nuova pinza per l'emostasi prowisoria dei grand! vasi profondi. Riforma med, 1927, 43: 584.—McKenzie, K. G. Some minor modifications of Harvey Cushing's silver cUp outfit. Surg. Gyn. Obst, 1927, 45: 549.—Matis, E. I. The use of haemostat clip3 in oto-rhino- laryngology. Acta otolar, Stockh, 1941, 29: 159.—Mayer, L. L'hdmostase temporaire par les pinces k demeure en chirurgie abdominale. Bruxelles mdd, 1927-28, 8: 564-7.—Payne, R. L. An improved hemostatic forceps. Am. J. Surg, 1932, n. ser, 16: 333. Also repr.—Pflugmacher. Bandages hdmostatiques. Rev. internat. Croix-Rouge, 1934, 16: 5; 641-8, 4 pl.—Prima, C. Hat der Esmarchschlauch noch seine Berechtigung? Zbl. Chir, 1937, 64: 2618-20.—Robinson, W. W. Zonal hemor- rhage-checking compression plate. U. S. Patent Off, 1939, No. 2,152,922.—Rolland, P. Hdmostase et pansement post- opdratoire en art dentaire. Rev. odont. Par, 1929, 50: 18- 38.—Sin, D. Die experimenteUen Studien fiber die Schocker- scheinungen, die bei der experimentellen Abschniirung mit dem sogennanten Esmarchschen Schlauche in Sicht kommen. Jap. J. M. Sc, 1940, 13: Proc. Pharm, 106-9.—Squirru, C. M. Nuevo mdtodo de hemostasia; ag6filo presion elastica, modifi- cation del mdtodo de Simpson. Rev. san. mil, B. Air, 1941, 40: 115-23.—Steinmann, F. Die langsgeriefte Arterienklemme. Zbl. Chir.. 1929, 56: 1747.—Trice, S. T. Electrical hemostat. U. S. Patent Off, 1939, No. 2,144,090.—Warren, A. F. Pres- entation of instrument: scissors-hemostat. Laryngoscope, 1933, 43: 417.—Winters, V. M. E. [New hemostatic appara- tus] Ned. tschr. geneesk, 1935, 79: 5189-93. ------• Un nouveau bandage hdmostatique. Sess. Off. internat. docum. mdd. mU. (1935) 1937, 5. Sess, 29-33. HEMOSTATIC. See also Blood coagulation, Pharmacology: Coagulants; also under names of hemostatic agents as Calcium; Citric acid; Congo red, &c. Francke [K.] H. [J.] *Blutstillungsmittel und -Methoden in der Zahnheilkunde mit Ausschluss der Therapie bei hamorrhagischen Diathesen [Leipzig] 36p. 8? Zeulenroda, 1934. Del Mastro, G. Osservazioni su gli stittici e acque emosta- tiche. FiUatre sebezio, Nap, 1841, 22: 200-4.—Imaz, I. Medicacidn hemost&tica. Accion mdd, B. Air, 1940, 10: 161; 168.—Knight, E. The appUcation of fungi as styptics. Brit. M. J, 1913, 1: 437—Marchal, G. Les mddications hdmostatiques. In Thdr. mdd. (Loeper, M.) Par, 1933, 6: 294-311.—Martinez Pineiro, M, & Sanz Hubert, G. El citrato de sosa y la transfusion sangufnea como hemostiticos. Med. ibera, 1927, 21: pt 2, 170-3.—Oldham, S. Drugs for the treatment of haemorrhage. Nurs. Times, Lond, 1938, 34: 1081-^3.—Rolland, P. Les mddicaments hdmostatiques. HEMOSTATIC Odontologie, Par, 1929, 67: 695-703.—Scheepe, F. L. [Hemo- statics in symptomatic treatment of pulmonary hemorrhages and menorrhagia] Geneesk. tschr. Ned. Indie, 1939, 79: 1813- 6.—Schmid, H. O. Ueber die Beeinflussung der Blutungen durch Hiimostyptica. Chirurg, 1937, 9: 329-31.—Walther, H. Blutungen in der gynakologischen Praxis mit besonderer Berucksichtigung der Hamostyptika.. Frauenarzt, 1912, 27: ---- Biological products. Binet, J. *Action hemostatique des extraits de plaquettes sanguines en injections sous-cuta- nees. 61p. 8? Par., 1933: Attalah, E. A terapdutica das hemorragias por meio dum extracto hematico. Actas Ciba, Rio, 1941, 8: 218.—Bick, M, & Drevermann, E. B. The use of pooled human serum for the treatment of haemorrhage and shock. Med. J. Australia, 1941, \r ^^-4'—Bonn> H. K. Further clinical studies of coagulen Kocher-Fonio; special reference to coagulen usage at the operating table. Indianapolis M. J, 1922, 25: 296.—Bressot, E. El empleo del suero de Normet en el tratamiento de election de la hemorragias y del shock. Cr6n. mdd. mex, 1931, 30: 207-9.—Buffagni, S. Emostasi ottenuta per mezzo di iniezioni di latte sterile. Terapia, Milano, 1932, 22: 17.—Burceva, E. Transfusion kleiner konservierter Plasmamengen zwecks Blutstillung. Arch. klin. Chir, 1935, 182: 710-7.—Crainicianu, A. Recherches cUniques sur Taction hdmostatique de certaines hormones. Bull. Acad. mdd. Roumanie, 1936, 1: 231-4 — Crut, G. De la thrombase comme agent hdmostatique. Bull. Acad, mdd. Par, 1936, 3. ser, 115: 499-502.—Dangerous bleeding stopped by new thrombin preparation. Science News Lett, 1940, 37: 179.—Dufour, H. De l'hdmostase mddicale: anthema. J. mdd. Paris, 1930, 50: 153-5.—Effect (The) of theelin on bleeding in nonhemophiUc patients. J. Am. M. Ass, 1937, 108: 1344.—Ferracciu, D. II coaguleno in gine- cologia. Riv. ostet. gin, 1922, 4: 415-23.—Gold, H. The con- trol of hemorrhage by thromboplastic agents. Internat. Clin, 1932, 42. ser, 2: 293; 3: 237.—Mamon, J, & Pineau. Emploi du sdrum de cheval comme hdmostatique en injections intra- tissulaires k doses tres faibles. BuU. Acad, mdd. Par, 1934, 3. ser, 112: 641-5.—Heinberg, C. J. Treatment of hemorrhage in nonhemophiUc patients with an estrogenic substance. Arch. Otolar, Chic, 1936, 24: 758-61.—Henry, A. Actions coagu- lantes comparatives du sdrum frais et des extraits d'organes frais sur le sang et le plasma des hdmophiles. C. rend. Soc. biol, 1910, 68: 531-3.—Jost, W. Ueber die Wirkung der oralen Coagulenzufuhr in kUnischer und experimenteller Hinsicht. Korbl. Schweiz. Aerzte, 1919, 49: 1909-19.—Kormos, A. Effect of coagulen injections. Magy. orv. arch, 1934, 35: 117- 23.—Leukert, B. Klinische Erfahrungen mit dem neuen BlutstiUungsmittel Sistonin. Med. Klin, Berl, 1927, 23: 581.—Lindenfeld, L. L'action hdmostatique du lait de femme. Presse mdd, 1935, 43: 1332.—Liu, S. H. Tissue fibrinogen in the treatment of hemorrhage. Nat. M. J. China, 1928, 14: 283-93.—Magladery, J. W, Solandt, D. Y, & Best, C. H. Serum and plasma in treatment of haemorrhage in experi- mental animals. Brit. M. J, 1940, 2: 248-50.—Minz, S. Le nuove vitamine antiemorragiehe. Probl. aUment, Roma, 1937-38, 2. ser, 1: 45.—Moller-Christensen, E. [Observations on the new hemostatic: trombisol Leo (thrombin solution)] Ugeskr. laeger, 1935, 97: 147.—Morisson, R. A. F. Traitement des hdmorrhagies graves par le sdrum citrate de Normet. Arch. mdd. pharm. mil, 1930, 92: 87-96.—Neuwelt, F, Levinson, S. O. [et al.] Further studies of hemorrhage and serum infusion. Surgery, 1940, 8: 644-7.—Oike, M. Self- blood injection arresting the hemorrhage of female genitals. Jap. J. Obst. Gyn, 1931, 14: 461-3.—Orth, O. Ein Beitrag zur Blutstillung mit besonderer Berucksichtigung der Supra- reninblutleere. Med. Welt, 1934, 8: 445-7.— Peck, S. M. The use of moccasin venom in hemorrhagic conditions. In Pract. Libr. M. & S. (Appleton) N. Y„ 1938, Suppl, 512-27 — Perret, C. A. De l'emploi du coagulene,en mddecine et chi- rurgie. Rev. mdd. Suisse rom, 1922, 42: 15-33.—Poemny, F. A. [Use of autocytovivocoll for checking hemorrhages from the parenchymatous organs] Khirurgia, Moskva, 1937, No. 9, 32-7.—Rastelli, E. Valore curativo di un nuovo emostatico: la trombocitina. PoUclinico, 1935, 42: sez. prat, 2158-63.— Rosenfeld, S, & Lenke, S. E. Method of and pledget for the treatment of accessible hemorrhage with snake venom having blood coagulating properties in vitro. U. S. Patent Off, 1938, No. 2,120,680.—Schwochow, K. Eigenserum als BlutstiUungs- mittel. Deut. tierarztl. Wschr, 1941, 49: 83-5. ------ Homologous serum as haemorrhage arrestor. Vet. Bull, Lond, 1942, 12: 122.—Sedlacek, E. Stillung kapillarer Blutungen durch Cebion. Med. KUn, Berl, 1935, 31: 848 — Sole, A. Die Muttermilch als BlutstiUungsmittel. Klin. Wschr, 1935, 14: 1354-9— Tagnon, H. J, & Taylor, F. H. I, Effect on coagulation time of oral administration of rabbit thrombin. Proc. Soc. Exp. Biol, N. Y, 1942, 49: 32-4.— Tingay, L. H. A case of persistent hemorrhage and the use of moccasin venom. Dent. Bull, CarUsIe, 1935, 6: 111-5.— Veiga, O. Soro hemostatico. Mem. Inst. Butantan, 1918, 1: 53-6.—Warner, E. D., Brinkhous, K. M. [et al.] Further experience with the use of thrombin as a hemostatic agent. Proc. Soc. Exp. Biol, N. Y, 1939, 41: 655-7. Also repr.— Wright, A. E. A note on the preparation and employment of physiological styptics. Lancet, Lond, 1893, 1: 435. HEMOSTATIC 572 HEMOSTATIC ---- Pharmacology. Axc.lade, L. *Contribution a l'etude dos hdmostatiques a base de pcctine et de ferments v6getaux. 77p. S? Par., 1929. Jurgens, R. *BlutstilIungsregulationen unter dem Einfluss von Blutegelextrakt. p.74-(S9. 8: tLpz.] 1928. Also Zschr. ges. exp. Med, 1928, 63: Almquist, H. J, : 4362-5.—Braun, W. Uebei Stypturnl in der gynakologisehen Praxis. Fortsch. Med, 1922, 10: 295.—Derouaux, G. Etude expdrimentale do l'action hdmostatique dune pectine et de l'adrdnalone. C rend. Soc. biol, 1937, 124: 567.—Dietrich, S, & Octtcl. IL Behandlung von Blutungskrankheiten mit Pcktinen. Deut med. Wschr, 1937, 63: 1690-4.—Freund. IL |()n the most recent experiences with Sangostop] Ned. tschr. geneesk, 1910 84: 2720-34.—Fritzsche, G. TufTon im Tier versuch. Zbl' Chir, 1939, 66: 2010-4—Geissendorfer, R. Untersuchungen' iiber das BlutstiUungsmittel TufTon. Arch. klin. Chir, 1937 189: 415-23 [Discussion] 94.— Gentile, G. Sopra un nuovo emostatico Tuffon. Policlinico, 1938, 45: sez. prat, 1039-11. - Gohrbandt, Wichman [et al.] Berichte iiber die blutstillende Wirkung von Sango-Stop aus Klinik und Praxis (mitgeteilt von der wissenschaftlichen Abteilung der Turon-Gesellschafl Frankfurt am Main) Med. Welt, 1935, 9: p. ix.— Grimme, ('! Ueber Capsella Bursa pastoris als Hamostyptikum. Munch med. Wschr, 1919, 66: 1117.—Hadorn, W. Ueber das Pektin- derivat Sango-Stop, ein kolloides BlutstiUungsmittel. Praxis, Hem, 1930. 25: 749.—Jezierski, T. [Snngo-stop in gynecology ami obstetrics] Polska gaz. lek, 1939, 18: 591.—Languor, f„ & Hnndelink, H. Considdrations objectives et subjoctivos obtenues lors de l'application clinique du Sangostop en O. R L. pratique. Bruxelles mdd, 1936-37, 17: 1567-70.—Leclcrc! H. Hdmorragies; phytothdrapie. In Annde m.'d. prat. Par, 1939, 18: 196.—Muerdago (El) en las hemoptisis y en las hemorragias en general. Med. ibera, 1936, 30: 57.—Schuster, J. M. Ueber die Wirkung des Hacmostypticums Styptural liquid. Klin. ther. Wschr, 1921, 28: 319. ---- Preparations. ►Stampa. Emostatico-balsamico-detersivo. 21. 21 V.cm. Nap., 1874. Agranat, A. Congo red as a haemostatic. S. Afr. M. J 1936, 10: 332.—Antoniak-Czyzewska, Z, & Pcker, M. [Pep- tone injections for hemorrhages] Polska gaz. Idle, 1929, 8: 63.—Balsamo antihemorragico de Warren. Botica, Barcel 1853-54, 2: 276.—Becker, J. Blutstillung durch Kongorot (vorlaufige Mitteilung) Munch, med. Wschr., 1930, 77: 396.— Carvalho, S. La liqueur stiptique de Weber. Bull. Soc. fr hist, mdd, 1927, 21: 282-6.—Demel, R. Die richtige Ver- wendung des Stryphnons als BlutstiUungsmittel. Zbl. Gyn, Lpz, 1932, 56: 267.—Deuticke, P. Practical therapeutics; hemostatic control of bleeding; with specific reference to stryph- non. Med. J. & Rec, 1931, 131: 503.—Doisy, E. A. Anti- hemorrhagic compounds. Proc. Mayo Clin, 1911, 16: 293.— Eason, J. The arrest of haemorrhage by hypertonic glucose solution; some clinical examples. Lancet, Lond, 1932, 2: 1272.—Fieser, I, F. Convenient procedures for the preparation of antihemorrhagic compounds. J. Biol. Chem, 1940, 133: 391-6. Also repr.—Forlini, E. L'uso di una nuova soluzione a base di citrati niclallici dopo emorragie gravi. Rass. ter. pat. elin, 1930, 2: 705-20.— Graves, R. C, & Kickham, C. J. L. Congo red for the control of bleeding. N. England J. .VI., 1936, 214: 782.—Grieco, F. Emostasi degli organi parenchimatosi col lanital. Arch. ital. chir, 1939, 57: 291-311.—Hernandez Diaz, A. La terapdutica hemostatica por el rojo congo. Arch. med, Madr, 1935, 38: 563-7.—Jannulis, G. E. Ueber tin praktisches BlutstiUungsmittel. Mschr. Ohrenh, 1934, 68: 1234.—Kormos, A. [Intravenous hypertonic salt solution as hemostyptic] Orv. hetil, 1933, 77: 705-8.—Kosdoba, A. 7, [Hemostatic properties of the bone-blood preparation Sangosj Sovet. khir, 1933, 4: 276-8.—Kuntschik, R. Ueber die Ver- wendung von Stryphnon als BlutstiUungsmittel in der Gynako- logie. Wien. klin. Wschr, 1928, 41: 1223-5.—Morra, G, & Prat, V. Ricerche suU'azione emostatica di un derivato dell'acido poligalatturonico. Ginecologia, Tor, 1939, 5: 387-97.— Pickering, J. W., & Hemingway, A. The efficacy and stand- ardization of haemostatics. Brit. M. .1, 1920, I: 1029-3L— Pomodoro, A. Calcioterapia emostatica: resoconto sperimen- tale; osservazioni; casistica. Rass. clin. ter, 1929, 28: 35-8 — Poudre haemostatique. Gaz. san. Par, 1833, 1: 93.—Prochet, V. Sull'impiego dello zimolattato di calcio neU'emosiasi. Rass. cUn. ter, 1932, 31: 1-5.—Richert, D., Thayer, S. A. [et al.] Bioassay of water-soluble antihemorrhagic compounds by intravenous administration. Proc. Soc. Exp. Biol, N. Y, 1940, 44: 601-4.—Schbnbauer, L. Dextroselbsung als Hamo- styptikum. Zbl. Chir, 1928, 55: 2378.—Schwyzer, A. Experi- ences with sistosan; a non-irritating hemostatic. Minnesota M, 1939, 22: 245-50.—Steinberg, A. Hemostatic. U. S. Patent Off, 1941, No. 2,268,347.—Wotzilka, G. Ueber ein neues BlutstUlungsmittel. Mschr. Ohrenh., 1933, 67: 838-40. ---- Tissue, and tissue extract. See Tissue; Tissue extract. HEMOTHERAPY. See also Blood transfusion; also under names of various diseases as Anemia, Treatment: Autohemotherapy; Brain, Apoplexy: Treatment, HEMOTHERAPY 573 HEMOTHERAPY Acuha, M, & Garcia Oliver, J. Le centre d'hdmothdrapie de l'lnstitut de pddiatrie et de pudriculture. Sem. mdd, B. Air, 1938, 45: 1145-7.—Birillo, I. A. [Arterial injections of blood in shock, agony and cessation of the heart's action] Khirurgia, Moskva, 1939, No. 8, 3-17.—Casoli, G. Ricerche di opoterapia sanguigna. Rass. internaz. chn. ter, 1927, 8: 379-87.—■ Central (La) de hemoterapia. Dia mdd, B. Air, 1939, 11: 314—Escomel, E. Hemoterapia venosa esplenoespecifica. Siglo mdd, 1927, 74: pt 2, 1-3.—Fischer, C. Ueber Eigenblut-, Eigenserum-, Fremdblut- und Fremdserumbehandlung. Med. Welt, 1936, 10: 1659-61.—Fischer, O. Un nuevo procedi- miento para la inyeccidn y toma de sangre. Rev. mdd. Ham- burgo, 1925, 6: 375-7.—Gyorgy, E. Rectal verabreichtes Blutplasma bei Sauglingen. Mschr. Kinderh, 1932, 54: 377.—Koschade, R. Erfahrungen mit Eigenblut- und Fremd- blutbehandlung. Deut. med. Wschr, 1940, 66:178.—Podolsky, E. The healers with blood. Med. Rec, N. Y, 1937, 146: 479-81.—Rapoport, M, & Stokes, J, jr. Reaction following the intramuscular injection of whole blood. Am. J. Dis. Child, 1937, 53: 471-80.—Roshem, J. Propridtds magiques ou thdrapeutiques du sang de I'homme. Rev. mdd. Par, 1921, 38: 295-302.—Urbino, G. SuU'opoterapia sanguigna. Policlinico, 1926, 33: sez. prat, 1109-12. ---- autogenous. Rogers, L. D. Auto-hemic therapy; treating your blood with your own blood. 2. ed. 224p. 8? Chic., 1917. Achitouv, E. L'auto-hdmothdrapie. Presse mdd, 1934, 42: 2016.—Allergic and autoserologic therapy. Boston M. & S J, 1917, 177: 776.—Aoki, T. Beitrag zur Autohamotherapie. Mitt. Med. Akad. Kyoto, 1937, 19: 1859-61.—Autohemo- thdrapie (L') Rev. gdn. cUn. thdr, 1935, 49: 502-4.—Buhner, R. Ein Beitrag zur Eigenblutbehandlung. Hippokrates, Stuttg, 1939, 10: 183-5.—Burgess, N. Some observations on autohaemotherapy. Brit. J. Derm, 1932, 44: 124-31.— Cacciapuoti. G. B. L'influenza deU'ora della presa del sangue su e autoemoterapia. Ibid, 1935, 16: 1156-65.— Hirsch, L. Der Einfluss von Eigcnblutinjektionen auf das Blutbild. Deut. med. Wschr, 1926, 52: 1302.—Hoffheinz, S. Kritisches und Klinisches zur Eigenbluttherapie nach Vor- schiitz. Arch. klin. Chir, 1927, 111: 567-92.—Knosp, J. Ueber die euphorisierende Wirkung der Eiuenblutinjektionen. Munch, med. Wschr, 1926, 73: 820-2.—Lumiere, A, & Mon- tolov. Mode d'action de l'autohdmothdrapie. C. rend. Acad. sc, 1927, 184: 1136-8.—Lyon, G. Le bdan de l'auto-hdmo thdrapie. Bull, mdd. Par. 1937. 51 : 119.—Marri, E. SuU'azio- ne deU'autosangue (met. Amreluccii in varie forme oculari. Arch, ottalm, 1927, 34: 211-5. — Pazzagli, R. La formula leucocitaria neU'autoemoterapia in alcune infezioni chirurgiche. Gior. med. nul, 1930, 78: 380-5.—Schapiro, A. Experimentelle Studien iiber den Gehalt der Retikulocyten unter dem Einfluss der Autohamotherapie und der Schropfkopfe. Zschr. ge*. exp. Med, 1930, 71: 800-4.—SchUrer-Waldheim, F. Leber die Wirkungsweise der Eigenblutbehandlung. Deut. Zschr. Chir, 1933, 239: 352-62—Sciplino, F.. & La Grutta. I, Ri- cerche sulla reiniezione di sangue deUo stesso organismo; modificazioni di alcune propriety fisico-chimiche del siero. Riv. pat. sper, 1926, 1: 455 69.—Smirnov, O. [Mechanism of autohemotheiapy; and its practical application] Vrach. delo, 1927, 10: 965-71.—Sorrentino. C. Sul meccanismo d'azione deU'auloeinourapia; variazioni della velocity di sedimentazione e dell 'indice refrattometrico. Pediatria (Riv.) 1931, 39: 905-14.—SpiethofT. B. Defibriniertes Eigenblut in der Reiztherapie. Miinch. med. Wschr, 1922, 69: 1003.— Tatafiore, E. Le variazione del potere complementare nei lattanti distrofici durante l'emoterapia materna. Rinasc. med, 1936, 13: 301.—Waintraub, I, C. Sur le mode d'action de l'autohdmothdrapie. Bull. Soc. fr. derm, syph, 1933, 40: 1798-802.—Yanaihara, K. Khnisdres und Experimentelles Studium uber haemolysierte Eigenblutinjektionstherapie. Nippon fujinkagakkai zasshi, 1934, 29: 8-14. ---- autogenous: Untoward effect. Jouan, S. Peligros graves de la autohemoterapia practicada sin diagndsticos rigurosamente controladus. Rev. mdd. lat amer, B. Air, 1930-31, 16: 3S3-5.--Makarov, A. A. [Does injection of autogenetic blood produce nidation/] KUn. med, Moskva, 1026, 4: 118-51.—Siemens, H. W. [Toxic manifesta- tions following injection of patient's own blood] Ned. tschr. geneesk, 1939, 83: .3101-3. ---- combined. See also Hormone. Fildek.yian, M. *L'h6mocrinoth6rapie. 96p. 8? Par., 1934. Filderman, L. Faits nouveaux relatifs k l'hdmocrinothdra- pie. BuU. Soc. mdd. Paris, 1932, 630-6. ------ L'hemo- crinothdrapie; gdndrahtds, particularitds, raretds. CUnioue Par, 1940, 35: 6-9. ---- heterogenous. See also Shock therapy. Jungmann, M. *Die therapeutische Wirkung des Pferdeblutes [Leipzig] 12 p. 8°. Bresl 1921. Bier. A. Zur Theorie und Praxis der Behandluno- mit Tierbluteinspritzungen. Med. Welt, 1934. 8: 1267-70 — Ehrlirh, H. Ueber intravenose Tierblutinjektion nach Kisch Deut. med. Wschr, 1925, 51: 1366.—Kriazhimsky, E. v! [Therapy with incompatible blood of a different group] Khi- rurgia Moskva, 1938, No. 2, 27-34.—Lacina, J. [Effect of heterohemotherapy in infectious diseases and hemorrhagic diathesis] Cas. ldk. Cesk, 1931, 70: 680-3.—Paltrinieri, G. Sulle alterazioni istologiche da sangue eterogeneo riscaldato Gazz. mteniaz. med. chir, 1934, 42: 197-204. —Pommerenke, V\ . I , Slavin, H. B. [et al.] Dog plasma protein given by vein utilized in body metabolism of dog; horse plasma and dog hemoglobin not similarly utilized. J. Exp. M, 1935 61- 283-97.—Ryss, S., & Stroikova, X. Die Shocktherapie einiger Erkrankungen des Verdauungskanals mittels intravenoser ,7SJe^bH,nog.y0rl heterogenem Blut. Arch. klin. Chir, lyoo, lo5: 38—54. ---- Indication. Bruder, J. *Les injections de sang dans la therapeutique de la premiere enfance. 74n 8° Par., 1928. P' Protti, G. L'emoinnesto intramuscolare e le radiazioni vitali nella vecchiaia e neU'esaunmento 140p. 8? Milano, 1931. Barabas Z. [Value of blood therapy in infants] Budapesti orv. ujs 1932, 30: 910.-Bau.nann, W. Die Behandlung schwerer Ernahrungsstorungen und infektidser Erkrankungen mit Ueberpflanzungen von menschUchem Blut odei EinspTiz- zungen menschlichen Serums. Mschr. Kinderh 1929-30 4.- • o09-22 —Boisserie- Lacroix & Monmayou. Les injections' .jus-cutandes de sang dans le traitement des maladies du nourrisson. J. mdd. Bordeaux, 1939, 116: pt 1, 342.—Brossa, A. La hemoterapia en pediatria. Med. ibera, 1936 30' 318-21.—Friedman, E. I, & Emelianova, E. P. [On liemo- therapy in some diseases in infants] Vrach. delo, 192s. U; 18IS-52.—Gibson, G. \ preliminary report on the sub- cutaneous injection of blood in the treatment of post par turn infection. N. York State J. M, 1929, 2!): 536.- Kovulenko, Z. P. [On the application of hemotherapy in children| Vadi'. atria, Moskva, 1941, No. 2, 4.5.— Kramar. J. [Practical value of convalescent and adult blood or serum in infectious diseasesl Orvoskdpzds, 1934, 24: 659-71.—Lages, W. Ligeiras con- sideracoes sobre a hemoterapia em pediatria. Labor can Rio, 1941, 21: 139-43.—Letsch, A. [Hemotherapy in chiidrra'a clinic] Vrach. gaz, 1927, 31: 1568-75. -Miley, (J. p. Acuto pyogenic infections. J. Am. Inst. Horneop, 1911, 31: 505 l().__ Nasso, I. Trasfusione di sangue ed euiotcrapia neH'infanzia Rinasc. med, 1935, 12: 291-3. Neboliubov. E. I, it Grinbcri; S. R. [Hemotherapy in children's diseases] Sovet pediat 1936, No. 11, 58-67.—Parke, T. I). Intramuscular blood injections as nutritional aids. South. M. J, 1921, 14: 460-2.__ Schachter, M. Contribution k 1'dtude de l'hdmothdrapie dans la pratique pddiatrique. Rev. fr. pediat, 1935, 11: 611-6.— Torresi, L. L'emoinnesto intramuscolare in alcune emopatie Radiobiologia, Venez, 1932-33, 1 : 93 -X. -Vlados, K. K, & Dultsin, M. S. [Hemotherapy in the clinic] Khirurgia Moskva, 1939, No. 1, 5-10.—Weissenbach. R. J. Indications particulidres et techniques des dilidrentes mdthodes d'hdmo- thdrapie parentdrale (auto- et isohdmothdrapie k l'exception de la transfusion du sang proprement dite par voie veineuse) Sem. hop. Paris, 1931, 7: 289-99. ---- Irradiated blood. Boehm, G. Eine Apparatur zur Ultraviolettbestrahlung dea Eigenblutes. Munch, med. Wschr, 1938, 85: 1330.—Braun, A. Ueber Reinjektion bestrahlten Eigenblutes; vorliiufi^e Mit> teilung. Ibid, 1933, 80: 211.—Kulenkampff, D. Ueber Be- handlung mit bestrahltem Eigenblut. Zschr. arztl. Fortbild, 1937, 34: 613.—Ortloph, W. Zur Behandlung mit bestrahltem Eigenblut. Hippokrates, Stuttg, 1937, 8: 1075.—Sulla terapia con sangue irradiato con radiazioni ultraviolette. Gazz. osp, 1937, 58: 27-31.—Terrizzano, M. F. La posibiUdad del uso de sangre o suero conservado, previamente irradiado, en el tratamiento de las afecciones de la sangre y aun de los blastomas; nota previa. Sem. mdd, B. Air, 1940, 47: 165. ---- Mode of action. Akkerman, J. H. [Dry blood in therapy] Geneesk. gids, 1932, 10: 918; 943.—Cavallaro, V. Azione vitaminica ed ipoglicemizzante di estratti di sangue umano normale. Ri- forma med, 1932, 48: 82.—Chapman, C. B. Human blood as a therapeutic agent. West Virginia M. J, 1938, 34: 437- 52.—Demidova, L. V. [Role of phagocytosis in hemotherapy] J. mikrob, Moskva, 1932, 9: 410-4.—Di Macco, G. Ricerche sulla reiniezione di sangue dello stesso organismo; modifica- zioni della stability di sospensione del sangue per azione deUe auto- ed etero-emazie. Riv. pat. sper, 1927, 2: 29-36.— Di Renzo, F. Comportamento del fibrinogeno e della trombina nella introduzione parenterale di sangue omologo. Ibid, 1926, 1: 282-8.—Halperin, E. P. [Gametocide and schizontocido features of hemotherapeutic preparations] J. mikrob, Moskva, 1937, 18: 242-7.—Hilgenberg, F, & Thomann, O. Experi- mentelle Untersuchungen iiber die Aufhebung von Giftresorp- tion durch abriegelnde Bluteinspritzung. Deut. Zschr. Chir. 1923, 180: 267-72.—La Grutta, L. Modificazioni deUa stability di sospensione del sangue per azione delle autoemoproteine e di alcune proteine eterogenee. Riv. pat. sper, 1927, 2: 140-9 — Metis, F. Vergleichende Untersuchungen uber die Wirkung hamolysierten und unveriinderten Blutes. Mschr. Kinderh., 1924-25, 29: 199-206.—Negri, C. Ricerche suU'eraoterapia; 1 azione deU'emoterapia su varie componenti del ricambio matenale neU'uomo; nota 1: l'azione dell'auto- e dell'etero- emoterapia sulla colesterinemia plasmatica e globulare. Gior. chn. med, 1935, 16: 885-900. ------ L'azione dell'auto- e deh eteroemoterapia suUe I!'azioni azotate del sangue. Ibid, 901-16. ------ & Chiodarelli, C. L'azione deU'auto- e deU eteroemoterapia sulla calcemia e sul tasso in cloruri ematici ed urinan. Ibid, 1041-55.—Negri, C, & Tattoni, G. L1 azione deU'auto- e dell'eteroemoterapia sulla diastasi ematica ed urinaria. Ibid, 1056-68.—Phemister, D. B. The vascular properties of traumatized and laked bloods and of blood from traumatized Umbs. Tr. Am. Surg. Ass, 1927, 45: 383-91. Also Ann. Surg, 1928, 87: 800-10. ------ & Handy, J. Vascular properties of traumatised and laked bloods. J. Physiol Lond, 1927-28, 64: 155-73.—Sack, R. I. [Experi- mental data on the effect of heterogenous blood, administered internally and rectally, on the blood and bone-marrow] Klin. med, Moskva, 1939, 17: No. 6, 79-82—Salazar. M. M. bupenondad de la hemoterapia sobre la sueroterapia. Siglo med 1935 96: 58-60.—Sturgis, C. C. Therapeutic value of ™»nd blood substitutes. Rocky Mountain M. J, 1941, SS: 274-86.—Zimmermann, R. Experimentelle Beitrage zur tJlutuberpflanzung und zur Blutresorption. Aerztl. Rdsch, t-i. , A221; Passim.—Zipf, K. Zur Kreislaufwirkung des triscn dehbrinierten Blutes. Arch. exp. Path, Berl., 1932, 167: °z}- .—~---* Wagenfeld, E, & Haale. E. Ueber die pharma- kologische Wirkung des frisch defibrinierten Blutes. Ibid., 1930, 150: 70: 91; 119. HEMOTHERAPY 575 HEMPEL .----■ oral. Robert, R. Ueber die Benutzung von Blut als Zusatz zu Nahrungsmitteln; ein Mahnwort zur Kriegszeit. 4. Aufl. 147p. 8? Stuttg., 1917. Winter, A. R. The nutritive value of blood- meal protein for growth. 42p. 8? Wooster, Ohio, 1929. Anderson, E. S. The'fate of swallowed blood. Univ Durham Coll. M. Gaz, 1930-31, 31: 67-70.—Balden, E. von. Die innerliche Darreichung von Tierblut. Med. Welt, 1932, 6: 699-701.—Erlich, M. Essai de traitement des nouveau-nds par le sang humain, appUqud par voie buccale. Rev. fr. pddiat, 1934, 10: 657-63.—Gauducheau, A. Recherches sur le sang aUmentaire suivies de considerations sur le rationnement des imponddrables. Rev. hyg. Par, 1926, 48: 420-44.—Schiff, L, Stevens, R. J. [et al.] Observations on the oral administration of titrated blood in man; the effect on the stools. Am. J. M Sc, 1942, 203: 409-12. ---- Veterinary use. Charton, J. *Essais d'hemotherapie pre- ventive et curative dans quelques affections des animaux [Alfort] 72p. 8? Par., 1927. Paltjssiere, P. M. E. *L'autohemotherapie en medecine v6terinaire [Alfort] 43p. 8? Par., 1926. Rigatjdieres, R. *De l'autohSmotherapie; son application au traitement des dermites suintantes des extremites chez le cheval. 70p, 8? Lyon, 1935. Brunschwick. Note sur les rdactions provoqudes par l'in- jection sous-cutande de sang bovin chez le cheval. Bull. Acad. vdt. France, 1933, 6: 429.—Lobl, J. [Autohemo- and auto- .serotherapy] AUatorv. lap, 1935, 58: 248-50.—Marcenac & Lemetayer. L'autohdmothdrapie sous-conjonctivale en thdra- peutique oculaire chez le cheval. Rev. vdt. mil. Par, 1929, 13: 399-408.—Melanidi, C, & Papachristophilou, P. L'auto- hdmothdrapie dans le traitement des affections fdbrdes du cheval. Arch. Inst. Pasteur heUdn, 1923-26, 1: 171-4.— Miller, W. C. Low temperature blood meals as a source of essential amino-acids for nutritive purposes. Vet. Rec, Lond, 1936, 16: 311-24.—Steffan, H. Die Behandlung mit ultra- violett bestrahltem Eigenblut beim Pferde. Zschr. Veterinark, 1939, 51: 147; 195, 4 pl.—Zeheter. Eigenblutbehandlung. Ibid, 1928.40: 100-4. HEMOTHORAX. See under Thorax. HEMOZOIN. See also Malaria, Pathology. Ghosh, B. N, & Nath, M. C. The chemical composition of malaria pigment (haemozoin) Rec. Malaria Surv. India, 1934, 4: 321-5.—Ghosh, B. N, & Sinton, J. A. Studies of malarial pigment (haemozoin) the reactions of haemozoin to tests for iron. Ibid, 43-59. ------ Further researches into the action of solvents, and the results of observations on the action of oxidising and reducing agents, on optical properties, and on crystalUsation. Ibid, 205-21. —----- Investigation of the action of solvents on haemozoin and the spectroscopical appearances observed in the solutions. Ibid, 15-42.—Trensz, F. Sur les propridtds antigdnes de l'hdmozo'ine. Bull. Soc. path. exot. Par, 1935, 28: 558-60. HEMP. See Apocynaceae; Cannabis. HEMPE, Karl, 1902- *Operative und sklerosierende Varicenbehandlung. 19p. 8? Bresl., Bresl. Genoss. Buchdr., 1930. HEMPEL, Annemarie, 1909- *Zur aku- ten todlichen Katatonie. 20p. 8? Greifsw., H. Adler, 1936. HEMPEL, Fanny Marianne, 1903- *Ein Beitrag zur Frage der angeborenen Ellbogen- luxationen. 20p. pl. 8? Freib. i. B., K. Henn, 1928. HEMPEL, Helena, 1905- *Ist der Hutcbinson-Zahn fiir Lues congenita charak- teristisch (pathognomonisch) ? [Leipzig] 30p. 8? Glauchau, J. Pickenhahn, 1931. HEMPEL, John Frederick, 1864-1933. [Obituary] Baltimore Health N, 1933, 10: 81. HEMPEL [Paul Georg] Herbert, 1906- *Khnische und experimentelle Untersuchungen uber die Frage der Mobilisation ankylotischer Handgelenke [Leipzig] 19p. 8? Zeulenroda, A Oberreuter, 1933. HEMPEL, Wolf, 1905- *Retikulozyten im Wochenbett [Jena] 29p. 8? Jastrow, K. Zentgraf, 1934. HEMPELMANN, Gertrud, 1912- *Bei- trage zur Klinik und Behandlung des Lupus erythematodes. 53p. 22}£cm. Bonn, R. Stodieck, 1937. HEMPFER, Hans, 1912- *Ein Fall von Dermoidcyste des Eierstocks mit Zahnen. 20p 8? Tub... A. Becht, 1938. HEMP industry. Glaser, S. *L'hygiene de l'industrie du chanvre. 36p. 8? Par., 1935. HEMPRICH, Heinz Hubertus, 1912- *Ueber Nachblutungen nach Zahnextraktion. 23p. 8? Munch., Hohenhaus, 1935. HEMPRICH, Rudolf, 1906- *Narkose und Kohlehydratstoffwechsel. p.439-72. 8° Kiel [n. pub.] 1931. Also Zschr. ges. exp. Med, 1932, 83: HEMPSTEAD, N. Y. Mercy Hospital. Reiley. R. J. The new Mercy Hospital, Hempstead, Long Island, New York. Hosp. Progr, 1941, 22: 365-70, plans. HEMSTERHUIJS, Johannes, 1656-1706. Napjus, J. W. [Professors of medicine at the University and the Athenaeum in Franeker (1585-1843) Johannes Hem- sterhuis] Ned. tschr. geneesk, 1939, 83: 4320-6. HEN. See Fowl. RENAULT, Jacques, 1913- . Considera- tions sur le traitement physiotherapique et chi- rurgical du cancer de la levre inferieure. 59p. 25>zcm. Lyon, M. & L. Riou, 1939. HENBANE. See Hyoscyamus. HENCH, Philip Showalter, 1896- Acute and chronic arthritis. p.l04-175L. 8? [Ro- chester, Minn.] 1935. Reprinted from Nelson Loose-Leaf Surgery. HENCKEL, George. Practical physician and home apothecary. 307p. 8? Chic, Smucker & co., 1891. ----& PERKINS, Orville Juan. Prescriptions and how to use them; an anatomical and physio- • logical treatise on the human body with a practi- cal description of its diseases, their symptoms and treatment. 6v. 8? Chic, Henckel & Perkins, 1891-92. HENCKEL, K[arl] O[tto] 1899- *Zur Entwicklungsgeschichte des Halbaffenschadels [Freiburg i. B.] p.365-83. 5 pl. 8? Stuttg., E. Schweizerbart, 1927. Also Zschr. Morph. Anthrop, 1927, 26: ---- Die Mikroveraschung (Veraschung mikroskopischer Schnitte) p. 1471-77. Berl., Urban & Schwarzenberg, 1932. In Abt. 5, T. 2, pt 2, Handb. biol. Arbeitsmeth. (Abderhal- den, E.) ---- Pfitzners Leitfaden fiir Situstibungen an der Leiche; zum Gebrauche bei Demonstrationen und Repetitionen. 9. Aufl. 38p. 16? Lpz., F. Deuticke, 1937. HENCKEL, Kurt [Wilhelm Max] 1904- *Ueber den Verlauf von Zwillingsschwanger- schaften und Zwillingsgeburten [Munster] 35p. 8? Werne-Lippe, F. Grube, 1934. HENCZYNSKI 576 HENDERSON HENTZYNSKI, Adolf. *Ueber den Einfluss der (iciiussmittel auf die Magenverdauung. 3S|>. S: Rostock, Adler's Erben, 1886. HEND, Hermann, 1905- *Ueber das Verhalten der Xahschusszeichen und der Stieuung der Schrotkorner bei Schrotflintenschiissen [Munchen] 40p. 3 tab. 8? Speyer, Pilger, 1934. HENDERSON, Agnes Elizabeth, -1925. Marnicol, M. Obituary. Mag. London School M. Women, 1925 --'ll, 21: 53-6. HENDERSON, David Kennedy, 1884- The affective reaction type (manic-depressive) including involutional melancholia, p.425-566. 8? X. Y. [1936] In Oxford Med. (Christian, H. A.) N. Y, 1936, 7: ----Psychopathic states. 178p. 21cm. X. Y., W. \V. Xorton & co. [1939] Thomas W. Salmon memorial lectures, N. Y. Acad. Med. ---- & GILLESPIE, Robert Dick. A text- book of psvchiatry for students and practitioners. x, 520p. 8? Lond., Oxford Univ. press, 1927. Also 3. ed. xii, 595p. 1932. Also 4. ed. xii, 606p. 1936. Also 5. ed. xii, 660p. 22cm. X. Y., Oxford Univ. press [1940] Oxford medical pubhcations. HENDERSON, E. P. See Preston. I•'. \\'., Henderson, E. P, & Randolph, James R. The Chicora (Butler County, Pa.) meteorite, p.387-416. 24cm. Wash, 1041. HENDERSON, Edward Erskine, 1870-1929. Obituary. Am. J. Ophth, 1929, 3. ser, 12: 1009. HENDERSON, Elmer Lee, 1885- IBioaraphy] Kentucky M. J, 1941, 39: 309. HENDERSON, Frank Laramore, 1865-1927- Notes on the eye, for the use of students, ix, 103p. 8? S. Louis, Shultz Pub. co., 1897. Also 2. ed. viii, 151p. Nixon-Jones print, co., 1900. For biography see J. Missouri M. Ass, 1927, 24: 377. HENDERSON, George W. Tabulated manual of anatomy, physiology and hygiene, together with the effects of alcohol upon the system. lolp. 8? Vaughnsville, 0., McKinley & Henderson, 1SS9. HENDERSON, Howard. Cremation. 46p. 16° Cincin., Cincinnati Cremation Co., 1891. HENDERSON, Isabella Ferguson, & HEN- DERSON, William Dawson. A dictionary of scientific terms, pronunciation, derivation, and definition of terms in biology, botany, zoology, anatomy, cytology, embryology, physiology. 2. ed., rev. xi, 352p. 22)^cm. Edinb., Oliver & Boyd, 1929. Also 3. ed. xii, 383p. 22«^cm. X. Y., D. Van Xostrand co., 1939. HENDERSON, John, 1876- Editor of Wheeler, Alexander, & Jack, WiUiam R. Wheeler and Jack's handbook of medicine. 9. ed. xvii, 654p. 12? Edinb, 1932. Also 10. ed. 703p. 8? Bait, 1937. HENDERSON, John, 1906- [Biography] Rocky Mountain M. J, 1942, 39: 131, portr. HENDERSON, John McAskill, 1895-1928. Obituary. Lancet, Lond, 1928, 2: 1319. HENDERSON, Joseph C. Studies of some amoebae from a termite of the genus Cubitermes. p.357-78. 3 pl. 26^cm. Berkeley, Univ. California press, 1941. Forms No. 14, v.43, Univ. California Pub. Zool. HENDERSON, Lawrence Joseph, 1878-1942. Blood; a study in general physiology, xix, 397p. 8? X. Haven, Yale Univ. press, 1928. ---- Pareto's General sociology; a physiolo- gist's interpretation, vii p. 2 1. 119p. diagr. 8? Cambr., Harvard Univ. press, 1935. See also Pennsylvania. University. Bicentennial con- ference. The study of man. 22p. 23cm. Phila, 1941. For biography seo J. Am. M. Ass, 1942, 118: 015. Also Rhode Island M. .1, 1942, 25: 65. Also Scit3nce, 1012 95- 316-8 (R. M. IVrrv) ---- & MURRAY, C. D. Nomographisehe Methoden bei der Untersuchung von Blut und Kreislauf. p.261-344. 8? Berl., 1935. In Handb. biol. Arbeitsmeth. (Abderhalden, E.) Berl, lO.'i.'i Abt. 5, T. 8, 261-344. HENDERSON, Louise. Practical nursing; an elementary condensed textbook for trained attendants and for use in practical home nursing 2. ed. xii, 2 1. 239p. 8? N. Y., Macmillan co ' 1929. HENDERSON, Mary F. Diet for the sick; a treatise on the values of foods, their application to special conditions of health and disease, and on the best methods of their preparation, ix. 234p. 8? N. Y., Harper & bros, 1885. HENDERSON, Olive Grace, & ROWELL, Hugh Grant. Good eyes for life, xiv, 202p. illust. pl. diagrs. 8? N. Y., D. Applet on- Century co., 1933. HENDERSON, Ruth Adele. See Harris, Florence La Gank, & Henderson, Ruth A Foods. 633p. 8? Bost, 1938. HENDERSON, Virginia. See Harmer, Bertha, & Henderson. V. Textbook of the principles and practice of nursing. 4. ed. 1047p. 22cm N. Y. [1939] HENDERSON, William Dawson, 1X66- See Henderson, I. F, & Henderson, W. D. A dictionary of scientific terms. 3. ed, rev. 383p. 22^cm. N. Y, 1939, HENDERSON, William Edward, 1870- See McPherson, William, & Henderson, William Edward. A course in general chemistry. 566p. roy. 8? Bost. [1913] ------ Exercises in chemistry [&c] Rev. ed. 143p. 8: Bost. [1933] HENDERSON, Yandell, 1873- A new deal in liquor, a plea for dilution. 8 1. 239p. illust. diagrs. 8? Garden City, N. Y., Double- day, Doran & co., 1934. ---- Adventures in respiration; modes of asphyxiation and methods of resuscitation, xi, 316p. illust. pl. diagr. 21cm. Bait., Williams & Wilkins co., 1938. ---- & HAGGARD, Howard W. Noxious gases and the principles of respiration influencing their action. 220p. 8? N. Y., Chem. Catalog co., 1927. See also Flury, Ferdinand, & Zernik, Franz. Schadliche Gase, Diimpfe, Nebel, Rauch- und Staubarten ... Noxious Gases von Henderson und Haggard. 637p. 8? Berl, 1931. HENDON, George Albert, 1871-1941. Obituary. J. Am. M. Ass, 1941, 117: 1907. Also Missis- sippi Doctor, 1941-42, 19: 325, portr.—Portrait. Ibid, 1936- 37, 14: No. 10, 30. HENDRICH, Margarete, 1908- *Zur Statistik des Lippencarcinoms: Bericht iiber 122 Falle der Chirurgischen Universitatsklinik Halle (Saale) aus der Zeit vom 1. 4. 1919 bis 31. 3. 1934. 17p. 8? Halle, E. Klinz, 1934. HENDRICK, Arthur Cinton, 1874-1940. Obituary. Canad. M. Ass. J, 1940, 43: 295. HENDRICK, Ellwood, 1861- Chemistry in everyday life; opportunities in chemistry. xii, 102p. 12? Lond., Univ. press, 1919. HENDRICK, Ives, 1898- Facts and theories of psychoanalysis. 3 1., xi, 308, xii p. diagrs. 21/2cm. N. Y., A. A. Knopf, 1935. Also 2. ed., rev. & enl. 3 p. 1. xiv, 62, 62a-62j, 63-369, xv p. diagr. 1941. HENDRICKS, Robert, 1912- *Ueber den Makrophagengehalt des Zahnfleisches in verschiedenen Lebensaltern [Tubingen] 20p. 8? Diisseld., G. H. Nolte, 1936. HENDRICKSON, George Oscar, 1890- See Wellhouse, W. H, & Hendrickson, O. O. College biology. 2. ed. 391p. 22cm. N. Y., 1939. HENDRICKX 577 HENKE HENDRICKX, Lambert Marie Felix, 1859- Frateur J. L. Eloge acad6mique. Bull. Acad. med. Belgi- n.iP 1939 6 ser, 4: 469-87, portr.—Guerin, C. Necrologie. Bull. Acad, med. Par, 1936, 3. ser, 116: 291. HENDRIOCK, Luise [geb. Schwarzhaupt] *Ueber zwei Falle eigenartig verlaufener Prostata- tuberkulose. 21p. 8? Marb., J. Hamel, 1930. HENDRIX, Georges. Les principes fonda- mentaux de la prothese orthopedique du membre inferieur, d'apres l'etude des membres artificiels- types, confectionnes dans les ateliers de prothese d*u Service de sant6 de l'Armee Beige a Rouen. xiii 99p pl 8? Par., A. Maloine & fils, 1917. HENDRY, William Belfry, 1874-1939. Scott, W. A. Obituary. Tr. Am. Gyn. Soc. (1939) 1940, 64: 289-91, HENDRY, William Edward, 1874-1934. Smith, F. M. [Biography] Proc. Connecticut M. Soc, 1934, 142: 297. HENDRY-CONNELL Research Foundation. See Kingston, Ont. HENENFELD, Ernest, 1912- *Contri- bution a l'etude de la radiographic d'urgence dans les syndromes abdominaux aigus. 56p. 25cm. Lyon, Paquet, 1937. HENES, Edwin, jr., 1885- Editor of Proceedings of the International Assembly of the Inter-State Post-Graduate Medical Association of North America. MUwaukee, 1928-31. HENGEN, Herman, 1907- *Versuche uber das Zusammenwirken von Alypin und Adrenalin an den Kreislauforganen. 19p. 8" Tiib. [n. pub.] 1935. HENGESBACH, Heinz, 1899- *Ueber Trauma und Tumor cerebri. 28p. 8? Bonn, J. F. Cartheus, 1925. HENGESBACH, Joseph, 1904- *Die Beeinflussung der Lipschitz'schen Xitroreduktion und der Ureasewirkung durch Morphin und Ko- kain. 16p. 8? Rostock, C. Hinstorff, 1935. HENGGE, Edwin. *Ueber einen Fall von traumatischem Abriss des Wurmfortsatzes. 38p. 8? [Zur., n. pub.] 1925. HENGGELER, Ernst, 1911- *Ueber perinephritische Abszesse. 24p. 8? Zur., Gebr. Leemann & co., 1937. HENGGELER, Karl [Julius] 1911- ln- tersuchungen iiber die Befahigung des mensch- lichen Hautorgans zur Neutralisation alkalischer Oberflachenwirkungen [Zurich] 24p. 23cm. Schwyz, F. Bisang, 1938. HENGSBACH, Richard [Johannes] 1908- *Ueber die Heilergebnisse der klinisch behandel- ten Dysmenorrhea. 25p. 8? Wiirzb., R. Mayr, 1936. HENGST, Erwin Rudolf, 1911- *Die intrauterine Radiumbehandlung gutartiger Ge- barmutterblutungen [Heidelberg] 19p. 8? Speyer, Pilger, 1938. HENGSTENBERG, Theodor, 1898- *Die Bedeutung der Oxyuren fiir die Chirurgie [Frei- burg] 15p. 8? Stuttg., B. Dummert, 1926. HENGSTMANN, Hans Georg, 1907- *Ueber Eklampsie und Blutgerinnung. 32p. S° Wurzb., V. Ganz, 1935. HENIUS, L. Samariter- und Rettungswesen. 116p. 8? Jena, G. Fischer, 1905. Forms 5. Bd, Handb. sozial. Med. HENKE, Erhard, 1897- *Zwei Falle von spontaner Spatruptur der Sehne des Extensor pollicis longus nach Handgelenktrauma, gleich- zeitig ein Beitrag zur Frage des Mechanismus der Sehnenschadigung bei diesem Krankheitsbild [Leipzig] 24p. 23cm. Zeulenroda, A. Ober- reuter, 1936. 227475—vol. 7, 4th series----37 HENKE, Ernst Heinz, 1907- *Maligne Tumoren der Mundschleimhaut. 52p. 8? [Berl., n. pub.] 1931. HENKE, Erwin, 1909- *Die akut ent- ziindlichen Erkrankungen im Gesicht. 37p. 23cm. Marb., J. A. Koch, 1937. HENKE, Friedrich, 1868- , & LU- BARSCH, O. Handbuch der speziellen patho- logischen Anatomie und Histologie. 27v. 8? Berl., J. Springer, 1924-39. HENKE, Gertrud, 1908- *Ueber Reck- linghausen'sche Krankheit mit Berucksichtigung der sarkomatosen Entartung von Nervenge- schwiilsten. 31p. 8? Konigsb. Pr., J. Raabe, 1934. HENKE, Herbert, 1909- *Der Kryptor- chismus und seine spontane Heilung. 37p. 23cm. Berl., R. Pfau, 1939. HENKE, Julie, 1908- *Schmelzhypo- plasien des bleibenden Gebisses unter Be- riicksichtigung der sozialen Schichtung des Volkes [Munster] 34p. 8? Quakenbruck, R. Kleinert, 1933. HENKE, M., TROJAN, G., & FRICK, E. Latein fiir Mediziner; ein praktisches Lehrbuch. viii, 134p. 8? Munch., H. Hueber, 1933. HENKE, Matthias, 1909- *Ueber manu- elle Placentarlosung und Austastung des Uterus nach der Geburt [Wurzburg] 19p. 8? Wert- heim, E. Beckstein, 1936. HENKEL, A. Weeds used in medicine. 45p. 8? Wash., Gov. Print. Off., 1904. Forms No. 188 Farmers BuU. U. S. Dep. Agr. HENKEL, Albert, 1913- *Die lahmende Wirkung fettsaurer Salze auf Nervenleitung und Hefegarung. 31p. 8? Tub., Bolzle, 1937. HENKEL, Alfred, 1914- *Dammerschlaf oder Schmerzerleichterung unter der Geburt? (unter besonderer Beriicksichtigung von Panto- pon) [Heidelberg] 24p. 21cm. Speyer, Pilger, 1938. HENKEL, Else [Elisabeth] 1910- * Ueber die Faktoren, von welchen die Prognose der offenen Lungentuberkulose des Kindes- und jugendlichen Alters abhangt. 15p. 8? Giessen, E. Seibert, 1937. HENKEL, Erhard, 1912- *Ueber die Krampfwirkung des Pyramidons. 19p. 23>£cm. Halle, E. Klinz, 1937. HENKEL [Erich] Heinz, 1909- *Ueber die Dehydrierungen und Oxydationen als selbst- standige Zelleistungen [Munster] 23p. 8? Wertheim, E. Bechstein, 1936. HENKEL, Gerhard, 1906- *Beitrage zur Pharmakologie des Indiums. 20p. 8°. Wiirzb., R. Mayr, 1932. HENKEL, Hanns, 1900- *Ueber Pneu- matosis cystoides unter Mitverwertung eines an der Chirurgischen Universitatsklinik Marburg beobachteten Falles [Marburg] 31p. 3 tab. 8? Kirchhain, B. Rindt, 1929. HENKEL, Klaus, 1909- *Wiederholte Schwangerschaften nach Kaiserschnitten. 21p. 8° Munch., Hohenhaus, 1935. HENKEL, Ludwig August, 1914- *Die Anwendungsmoglichkeit der verschiedenen Sepa- rationen in der Orthodontie [Frankfurt a. M.] 13p. 8? Wertheim, E. Bechstein, 1937. HENKEL, Max, 1870- Krankheiten der ausseren Geschlechtsteile und der Vagina, der weiblichen Blase, des Harnleiters und der Harn- rohre: Gonorrhoe, Syphilis und Tuberkulose der weiblichen Geschlechtsorgane. 95p. 8? Lpz., G. Thieme, 1921. Forms H. 1, Abt. Gyn., Diagn. ther. Irrtiim. HENKEL 578 HENNA HENKEL, Paul, 1904- *Therapie bei Insekten.-tichen. 20p. 8? Wiirzb., G. Grasser, 1929. HENKEL, Paul [Heinrich] 1908- *Ulcus ventriculi und Tabes. 36p. 22^cm. Berl., F. Linke, 1937. HENKEL, Trude, 1911- *Liquor und Herpes zoster. 28p. 22cm. Koln, J. Borowsky, 1936. HENKEL, Wilhelm, 1909- lntersuchun- gen iiber den Rhodangehalt des menschlichen Speichels und dessen Schwankungen bei XTorma- len und Karieskranken. 16p. 8? Frankf. a. M., O. E. Schroder, 1933. HENKEL, Willi, 1908- *Ueber Ver- anderungen des Kalium-Calcium-Magnesium- spiegels im Blut. 24p. 8? Frankf. a. M., H. Munch, 1934. HENKEL, Willibald, 1909- *Das Ver- haltnis der Caries zur Reizdentinbildung bei Frontzahnen und Praemolaren. 22p. 21cm. Wiirzb., C. J. Becker, 1938. HENKELS, Paul, 1892- Lehrbuch der veterinarmedizinischen Rontgenkunde fiir Tier- arzte und Studierende der Veterinarmedizin. viii, 266p. 8? Berl., P. Parev, 1926. HENKER, Otto, 1874-1926. Einfiihrung in die Brillenlehre. 3 p. 1. 325p. pl. 8? Jena, Optikerschule, 1921. For biography see Zschr. ophth. Optik, 1926, 14: 33-5 (R. GreefT) HENKES, Sigfrid, 1905- *Das Krank- hei>sbild der Anteflectio molaris III des Unter- kiefers und seine Entfernung als typisch chir- urgische Operation [Freiburg i. B.] 26p. 8? Quakenbruck, C. Trute, 1933. HENKES [Wilhelm] Walther, 1902- *Funktionsergebnisse nach Attikoantrotomien. 21p. 8? Freib. i. B., E. Gross, 1929. HENKIN, Leo Justin, 1906- Darwinism in the English novel, 1860-1910; the impact of evolution on Victorian fiction. 5 p. 1. 303p. 23cm. N. Y., Corporate press, 1940. HENLE, Adolf R., 1864- See Graff, H, Henle, A. [et al.] Chirurgie der Wirbelsiiule und des Beckens. 6. Aufl. 1327p. 8? Stuttg, 1927. HENLE, Jacob, 1809-1895. On miasmata and contagia; transl. by George Rosen, p. 1., 77p. portr. 26cm. Bait., Johns Hopkins press, 1938. See also Haberling, W. From the life of Jacob Henle. Med. Life, 1929, 36: 501-7, 5 portr.—Rosen, G. Social aspects of Jacob Henle's medical thought. Bull. Inst. Hist. M, Bait, 1937, 5: 509-37. ------ Introduction to a translation of Jacob Henle, On miasmata and contagia. Ibid, 1938, 6: 907-10.| ------ Jacob Henle and William Farr, Ibid, 1941, 9: 585-9. HENLEY, Eugene H., 1884- *Factors related to muscular tension [Columbia Univ ] 44p. 8? X. Y., 1935. Forms No. 183, Arch. Psychol, N. Y. HENLEY, William Ernest, 1849-1903. Roudin, M. B, & Moschcowitz, E. The unpubUshed poems of In Hospital by WUUam Ernest Henley. BuU. Inst. Hist M, Bait, 1936, 4: 231-41, portr. For portrait see BuU. Inst. Hist. M, 1938, 6: 907. HENN, Kurt, 1911- *Der Gasbrand; Studie an Hand von 19 Fallen der Heidelberger chirurgischen Klinik [Heidelberg] 24p. 20}£cm Kandel, Deininger [1935] HENN, Walter, 1909- *Die moderne Therapie des Tetanus [Marburg] 25p. 21cm Quakenbruck, R. Kleinert, 1936. HENNA. See also Cosmetic; Hair dye. Condelli, F. La henna in TripoUtania. BoU. chim. farm Milano, 1934, 73: 121; 161.—Cox, H. E. Hair dyes; the chemistry and analysis of henna. Analyst, Lond, 1938, 63: 397-404, pl.—Goldfarb, M. Ein FaU von Idiosynkrasie gegen das Haarfarbemittel Henna. Derm. Zschr, 1927, 50: 440. HENNEBERG, Hans, 1908- *Ueber die Grippenpneumonien 1933 [Rostock] 16p. 8? Greifsw., H. Adler, 1935. HENNEBERG, Hermann, 1904- *Die Behandlung der Prostata-Hypertrophie mit Ront- genstrahlen. 20p. 8? Giessen [K. Hansult] 1928. HENNEBERG, Rfichard] 1868- See Antoni, N, Henneberg, R. [et al.] Raumbeengende Prozesse. 417p. 8? Berl, 1936. HENNEBERG, Wilhelm, 1871-1936. Hand- buch der Garungsbakteriologie. 2. Aufl. 2v. xv, 602p.; xii, 403p. roy. 8? Berl., P. Parey, 1926. ---- Bakteriologie und Mykologie der Milch und der Milcherzeugnisse. p.429-87. 25^>cm. Berl., J. Springer, 1936. In Handb. Lebensmittelchem. (A. Bomer, et al.) Bd 3. For biography see Miinch. med. Wschr, 1936, 83: 941, portr. (A. Sehittenhelm) Also Zbl. Bakt, 2. Abt, 1930-31) 82: H. 23-6 (P. Lindner); 2. Abt, 1936, 94: 193 (K. H. Meewes, HENNECKE, Adolf [Otto Julius] 1899- *Ueber umschriebene Rindenreizkrampfe, eine Sondergruppe der Jacksonschen Epilepsie. 32p. 8? Halle, Karras, Krober & Nietschmann, 1929. HENNEGUY, Louis Felix, 1850-1928. Faure-Fremiet, E. [Necrologie] Arch. anat. micr. Par, 1928, 25: 1-36.—[Necrologie] Nature, Par, 1928, 56: 283.— Pellegrin, J. [Necrologie] Bull. Soc. zool. France, 1928, 53: 134-8. HENNEGUYA. See Myxosporidia. HENNEKE, Hans, 1905- *Ueber die in den Jahren 1925-1929 an der Universitats- Augenklinik zu Wurzburg beobachteten Falle von Opticusatrophie [Wurzburg] 24p. 8? Diiren, M. Danielewski, 1932. HENNEMAN, Richard Hubard, 1908- *A photometric study of the perception of object color [Columbia Univ.] 89p. 8? N. Y., 1935. Forms No. 179, Arch. Psychol, N. Y. HENNEMANN, Albert, 1913- *Vitamin C und die Schwangerschaftsanamie [Heidel- berg] 16p. 21cm. Zweibrucken [n. pub.] 1938. HENNEMANN, Friedrich, 1910- *Der Hallux rigidus unter besonderer Berucksichtigung seines Vorkommens im jugendlichen Alter [Heidelberg] 17p. 21cm. Wurzb., R. Mayr, 1938. HENNEMANN, Karl, 1912- *Die Des- infektionskraft einiger Formaldehydseifenprapa- rate. 14p. 21cm. Miinst., T. Brocker, 1936. HENNEMEYER, Eberhard, 1906- ♦Un- tersuchungen iiber den Gehalt an Rezeptoren und Antikorpern (Agglutininen) im menschlichen Speichel [Breslau] 24p. 2 1. 8? Ohlau, H. Eschenhagen, 1934. HENNENBERGER, K[arl] H[einz] 1911- *Ueber die Kondensation von Formaldehyd und Harnstoff [Karlsruhe] 72p. 21cm. Lpz., Frommhold & Wendler, 1936. HENNENBERGER, Lisa, 1909- *Zur Frage der Thymushyperplasie mit klinischen Beitragen. 22p. 8? Lpz., E. Glausch, 1933. HENNERKES, Bernhard, 1911- *Ueber den Zusammenhang der Kiefer- und Zahnstel- lungsanomalien und sozialer Lage bei den Volks- schulkindem Hemes [Wurzburg] 58p. 8? Wertheim, E. Bechstein, 1934. HENNES, Hermann, 1899- *Die Diag- nose der Spondylarthritis ankylopoetica (Morbus HENNES 579 HENNIG Bechterew) und ihre differenzialdiagnostischen Schwierigkeiten. 50p. 8? Bonn, H. Trapp, 1933. HENNES, Karl [Hermann] 1906- *Ueber den heutigen Stand der Kretschmer'schen Kor- perbaulehre. 35p. 8? Bonn, P. Kubens, 1932. HENNES, Michael, 1895- *Die Ab- hangigkeit der Eklampsieanfalle von meteoro- logischen Kaltlufteinwirkungen. 32p. 8? G5tt., Gott. Handelsdr., 1936. HENNES, Paula, 1900- * Ueber ange- borene Darmstenosen [Leipzig] p. 764-84. 8? Berl., J. Springer, 1928. Also Virchow's Arch, 1928-29, 270: HENNESSY, Harold Richard, 1903- Mil- itary medicine as a specialty; how can a knowl- edge of it be promoted in the medical profession in civil life and in the reserves. 22p. roy. 8? [n. p.] 1933. Typewritten. HENNESSY, Thomas, 1871-1936. Obituary. Brit. M. J, 1936, 1: 87, portr. Also Lancet, Lond, 1936, 1: 111, portr.—W. D. [Obituary] Irish J. M. Sc, 1936, 6. ser, 32, portr. HENNET, Henri, 1908- *La mort subite par les corps etrangers du larynx. 76p. 8? Par., Presses Univ. France, 1935. HENNICKE [Alma] Alice, 1905[?1- *Die in den letzten 10 Jahren in der Voelckerschen Klinik behandelten Falle von Nierentumor. 37p. 8? Halle, E. Klinz, 1931. • HENNICKE, Werner, 1910- *Die Er- fahrungen der chirurgischen Friihbehandlung lokaler Infektionen. 37p. 23cm. Marb., J. A. Koch, 1936. HENNIES, Erich, 1908- *Ueber die Beeinflussung der Mischungsgleichungen durch Umstimmung des Geschmackswerkzeuges. p.115-25. 8? Jena [n. pub.] 1933. Also Zschr. Psychol. Physiol. Sinnesorg, 2. Abt, 1933, 64: HENNIES, Hermann Wilhelm, 1907- *Die Bedeutung der Jodproben fiir die Diffe- rentialdiagnose Pemphigus oder Dermatitis her- petiformis Duhring. 24p. 21cm. Freib. i. B., Mors & Singler, 1937. HENNIG, Adalbert, 1906- *Ueber einen Fall von expulsiver Blutung nach Staroperation [Wurzburg] 14p. 8? Ochsenfurt, Fritz & Rappert, 1935. HENNIG, Arthur. Die Hennig-Heihveise; kurze Darstellung der Heilweise der Naturheil- kundigen. 39p. 16? Frankf., Kern, 1931. HENNIG, Elfried, 1908- *Blutdruck- messungen bei der kombinierten Chloralhydrat- Aethernarkose an Pferden. 37p. 8? Lpz., A. Edelmann, 1934. HENNIG, Herbert, 1897- *Spaltbil- dungen der Wirbelbogen im dorsalen und him- balen Bereiche der Wirbelsaule. 33p. 21cm. Konigsb. i. Pr., J. Raabe, 1938. HENNIG, Johannes, 1908- *Zur Ge- schichte des Goldinlays [Leipzig] 21p. 8! Wiirzb., R. Mayr, 1935. HENNIG, Martin, 1910- *Vergleichende Untersuchungen uber die Verdauungsleukozytose im Herz-und Pfortaderblut. 39p. 21cm. Halle, Grossbuchdr. Hall. Nachr., 1938. HENNIG [Martin] Erich, 1908- *Beitrag zur Histologie der Genitalorgane des weiblichen Silberfuchses mit besonderer Berucksichtigung der Histologie der Ovarien und Ovidukte. 42p. 8? Lpz., C. A. Walter, 1933. HENNIG, Max Emil. Homoopathische Phar- makopoe und Arzneimittellehre. 2. Aufl. 556p. 8? Berl., H. Pusch, 1935. HENNIG, Waldemar, 1908- *Beschrei- bung der Zahnleiste in einem Unterkiefer von Caiman sclerops. p.487-95. 8? Munch, [n. pub.] 1932. Also Morph. Jahrb, 1931, 68: HENNIG, Werner, 1902- *Ueber Lym- phangiome im Bereich der Mundhohle (Makro- glossie und Makrocheilie) 27p. 8? Halle [n. pub.] 1931. HENNIG, Werner, 1911- *Sekretions- anomalien der Nieren nach Katheterismus der Blase und der Ureteren. 23p. 8? Lpz., A. Edelmann, 1935: HENNIG, Werner [Richard] 1910- *Ueber die Schienenbehandlung der Radialislah- mung [Leipzig] 22p. 23cm. Zeulenroda, A. Oberreuter, 1936. HENNIG, Willy, 1905- *Die Chinidin- wirkung bei Herzerkrankungen [Berlin] 28p 8? Charlottenb., Gebr. Hoffmann, 1930. HENNIGES, Franz, 1912- *Ueber die Technik des Nachweises schwacher Agglutinine sowie der Faktoren M und N durch die Meniskus- reaktion nach Ponsold. 15p. 21cm. Wiirzb.. K. Triltsch, 1937. HENNING, Adolph, 1856- IBiography] In CoU. Pharm. N. York (Wimmer, C. P.) N. Y, 1929, 263, portr. HENNING, Artur. *Ueber Stirnhirnsyndrome [Rostock] 12p. 8? Berl., S. Karger, 1926. Also Mschr. Psychiatr, 1925, 59: HENNING, Dietrich [Martin] 1910- ln- tersuchungen iiber den diagnostischen Wert der Read'schen Formel beim Morbus Basedow. 20p. 8? Rostock, C. Hinstorff, 1935. HENNING, Esther Martha Brynhilda Pers- son, 1881- *Ohrenarztliche Untersuchun- gen von Schiilern der Taubstummenschulen Schwedens; nebst Bemerkungen zur Frage des Unterrichts der Schwerhorigen. vii, 278p. portr. 28 tab. roy. 8? Upps., Almqvist & Wiksell, 1928. HENNING, Hellmut, 1908- *Ueber die Beeinflussung der Saponinhaemolyse durch den Liquor cerebrospinalis. 32p. 8? Halle, Ostdt. Dr., 1935. HENNING, M. W. Animal diseases in South Africa. 2v. xi, 878p. paged consec. 127 illust. 8? [Johannesburg] Central News Agency, 1932. HENNING [Magdalene] Lydia, 1899- *Gelingt es bei Meerschweinchen mit Gemischen aus alkoholischen Extrakten arteigener Organe und Schweineserum positive Seroreaktionen sowie anaphylaktische Lipoid-Antikorper zu erzeugen? [Breslau] p. 19-33. 8? Jena, G. Fischer, 1928. Also Zschr. Immunforsch, 1928, 55: HENNING, Norbert, 1896- Die Ent- zundung des Magens. viii, 235p. illust. diagrs. 8? Lpz., J. A. Barth, 1934. ---- Die Verdauung, Resorption und Ernah- rung. p.211-87. 8? Jena, 1935. In Lehrb. spez. path. Physiol. (Becher, Bohnenkamp) Jena, 1935. ---- Lehrbuch der Gastroskopie. vi, 88p. illust. pl. 8? Lpz., J. A. Barth, 1935. ---- The same. Textbook of gastroscopy; transl. by Harold W. Rodgers. xii, 86p. illust. 7 pl. 18cm. Lond., Oxford Univ. press, 1937. ---- Die Krankheiten des Darmes. p.791- 998. 25cm. Berl., J. Springer, 1938. In Handb. inn. Med. (G. v. Bergmann [et al.]) T. 2, Bd 3. HENNING, Walter [Wilhelm August] 1898- *Ueber die Resorption und Abfiihrwirkung der Sulfate [Jena] 35p. 8? Borna, R. Noske, 1927. HENNINGER HENNINGER, Charles, H., 1874- Biography. Pennsylvania M. J, 1938-39, 42: 1512, portr. HENNINGS, Harro, 1906- *Zur Klinik der Tumoren des Mundes und Rachens. 40p. pl. 8? Marb., J. Hamel, 1933. HENNINGS, Rudolf, 1912- 'Ueber fokale Infektion unter besonderer Berucksichtigung der Polyarthritis [Heidelberg] 19p. 21cm. Lenge- rich, Lenger. Handeldr., 1938. HENNINGS, Walter, 1907- *Verglei- chend-anatomische, histologische und histogene- tische Untersuchungen iiber die Knorpel der Kniescheibe bei Pferd und Rind. 25p. 6 pl. 2 1. 8? Giessen, Xoske, 1935. HENNINGSEN, Otto, 1907- *Zur Frage der cholamischen Blutungen (klinische und experimentelle Untersuchungen) [Giessen] 32p. 8? Homberg-Oberhessen, W. Spamer, 1933. HENNION, Pierre Jean Paul, 1902- *Asthme et maladie de Basedow. 118p. -8? Par., A. Maloine & fils, 1929. HENNION, Pierre Maurice Ghislain, 1899- *Contribution k l'etude du lupus primitif de la muqueuse buccale. 72p. 8? Par., Jouve & cie, 1928. HENNIQUAU, Gerard, 1909- *L'al- coolisation du nerf phrenique; test de la phreni- cectoinie. 122p. 24cm. Lille, A. Durant, 1934. HENNRICH, Rudolf [Otto] 1906- *Spon- tane Kammerblutungen bei Diabetes. lOp. 8? Wiirzb., K. Triltsch, 1932. HENNY, Leonard. *Contribution a l'etude du systeme ternaire saccharose, chaux, eau. [Strasb.] 94p. 8? Colmar, Imp. Alsatia, 1936. HENOCH'S purpura. See under Hemorrhagic diathesis. HENRARD, Etienne. Quinze cas d'extraction de corps etrangers de l'oesophage chez l'enfant au moyen d'une pince a branche glissante sous l'ecran radioscopique dans l'examen lateral. 6p. 8? Brux., Impr. L. Severeyn [1907] HENRI, of Denmark, -1244? Wickersheimer, E. La veritable origine de maitre Henri de Danemarche, medecine oil6anais au temps de Philippe- Auguste. Janus, Leyde, 1933, 37: 354-6. HENRI, Guy, 1902- *Les chondrites costales primitives de la seconde enfance [Paris] 114p. 8? Foix, Fra & cie, 1926. HENRIC, Marcel, 1907- *Les grossesses tubaires recidivantes bilaterales. 135p. 25^cm. Bord., Y. Cadoret, 1933. HENRICH [Eberhard] Karl, 1908- *Die Fernresultate von 408 Choledochotomien aus den Jahren 1916-32 [Giessen] 44p. 8? Quaken- bruck, R. Kleinert, 1934. HENRICH, Emil, 1904- *Ueber Nekrose des Hodens im Anschluss an Zirkulations- storungen (mit eigenen Fallen) 16p. 8? Hei- delb., Thieme, 1931. HENRICH, Fritz, 1913- *Moderne Wur- zelbehandlungsmethoden [Munchen] 24p. 21cm. Gunzburg, K. Mayer, 1937. HENRICH, Hans [Joachim Eduard] 1905- *Ueber die Wirkung von Rettichsaft auf Leber und Gallenwege [Marburg] 28p. tab. 8? Lippstadt, Thiele, 1933. HENRICH, Kurt, 1909- *Wann kann eine Meniskusschadigung als Unfallfolge aufge- fasst werden? 36p. 8? Bonn, A. Brand, 1935. HENRICH, Ludwig, 1910- *Ueber die Vererbung der Ektopia lentis [Giessen] 26p. 21cm. Wurzb., K. Triltsch, 1937. HENRICH, Paul, 1903- *Ueber die Haufigkeit und Therapie des engen Beekens in HENRICH der Universitats-Frauenklinik zu Wurzburg in den Jahren 1925-28 [Wurzburg] 24p. s° Emsdetten, H. & .1. Lechte, 1935. HENRICH, Paul, 1904- *Ueber den Verlauf der Periphlebitis tuberculosa retinae. 43p. 8? Wiirzb., G. Crasser, 1931. HENRICHS, James R. See Train. P, Henrichs. J. R, & Archer, W. A. Mcdicinul uses of plants bv Indian tribes of Nevada. 3v. 2(iVacm Wash, 1941. HENRICHS, Otto, 1904- *Kann die Operation von Yokota die Eck'sche Fistel ersetzen? [Wurzburg] lOp. 8? Hamburg- Saar [n. pub.] 1929. HENRICHSEN, Georg Friedrich, 1891- *Zur Kasuistik der Urticaria papulosa perstans. 26p. 8? Frankf. a. M., F. Korber, 1917. HENRICI, Arthur Trautwein, 188<) Morphologic variation and the rate of growth of bacteria, v.l. xiii, 194p. 8? Springf., Ill, C. C Thomas, 1928. ---- Molds, yeast, and Actinomycetes; a handbook for students of bacteriology, x, 296p. 8? X. Y., J. Wiley & sons, 1930. ---- The biology of bacteria; an introduction to general microbiology, x p., 472p. illust. pl. 23cm. Bost., D. C. Heath & co. [1934] Also 2. ed. xiiip., 494p. illust. pl. diagr. [1939] HENRICI, Heinrich, 1909- *Trauma- tische Epiphysenlosungen an den langen Rohren- knochen der Extremitaten [Leipzig] 40p. 8? Zeulenroda, A. Oberreuter, 1935. HENRICSSON, Erik. *Epizootischer Abortus und Undulantfieber; eine epizootologisch-epi- demiologische Studie. xv, 203p. 3 maps, diagr. roy. 8? Stockh., I. Marcus, 1932. HENRICUS, de Hassia [Heinrich LangensteinJ 1325-97. Secreta sacerdotum. 12 1. sm. 4? Leipzig, Melchior Lotter, Oct. 27, 1499. HENRICUS, de Saxonia, 13. cent. Albertus Magnus de secretis mulierum [only the comment] 56 1. 8? Venezia, Adam of Rottweil, June 24, 1478. ---- The same [with comment] 34 1. 8? [Lyon, Michel Topie, ca 1488] ---- The same [with comment] 32 1. 8? [Paris, A. Caillaut, ca 1492] ---- The same [with comment] 44 1. 8° [Leipzig, Konrad Kachelofen, ca 1492] ---- The same [with comment] 38 1. sm. 4? Wien, Joannes Winterburg [ca 1500] —— The same [with comment] [42] 1. 15cm. [text] Lpz., Melchior Lotter, 1500. MS notes in German on verso of tp. and on f. Gc, with a long hexameter on priests by Hemgelhardus. ---- The same [with comment] ed. by Lucas Dulchinensis. [48] 1. 8? Venezia, Petrus Bergomas, 17. Oct., 1508. ---- The same. 44p. 32? [Paris, Nic. Roussel, 1513] Bound with Bayro. De preservatione pestilentiae. Par, 1513. ----The same. Heimlichkeit des weiblichen Geschlechts. 76 1. 8? Frankf. a. M., Joh. Feyerabend, 1592. ---- Liber aggregationis. 32 1. 4? Speyer, Johan & Conrad Hist [ca. 1483] ---- The same. 21 1. sm. 4? Kiiln, Heinrich Quentell [ca 1485] ---- The same. 51 1. 4? Anvers, Mathias van der Goes [ca 1491] ---- The same. De le virtu delherbe, animalli (!) et pietre preciose, e di molte maravegliose cose del mondo. 12 1. sm. 4? Venezia, Giovanni Battista Sessa, July 27, 1502. HENRICUS 581 HENRY ---- The same. The booke of secretes of Albertus Magnus of the vertues of herbes, stones and certayne beastes; also a booke of the same author of the maruaylous thinges of the world, and of certayn effectes caused of certayne beastes. 94 1. 15^ x 22cm. [Lond., W. Copland, ca 1565. Photostat facs. (H. E. Huntington Ubrary) HENRICUS, Martin. Carmen gratulatorium de dignitate et utilitatibus artis medicae; in honorem M. Georgii Agricolae Ambergensis scriptum. 4 1. 8? Wittenberg, C. Schleich & A. Schone, 1570. HENRIET, Rene, 1910- Contribution a l'etude de la mortinatality. 48p. 8? Par., Libr. E. Le Francois, 1938. HENRIJEAN, Francois, 1860-1932. Le coeur, les medicaments cardiaques et I'clectrocardio- gramme; recherches experimentales du Labora- toire de therapeutique de 1'University de Liege. 4 p. 1. ix, 252p. incl. diagr. 25cm. Liege, Impr. H. Vaillant-Carmanne, 1926. --- Le dualisme de la contraction cardiaque; recherches experimentales du Laboratoire de therapeutique de 1'Universite de Liege, xi, 350p. illust. 8? Par., Masson & cie, 1933 See also Halkin, M. Eloge du Professeur Francois Henrijean. BuU. Acad. med. Belgique, 1936, 6. ser, 1: 271-82, portr. ----& WAUCOMONT, R. La digitale. 192p. ch. 8? Par., Masson, 1930. --- Les medicaments antisyphilitiques. 186p. 12? Par., Masson, 1933. HENRION, Jacques, 1905- Contribu- tion a l'etude des variations de la formule leuco- cytaire sous l'influence de certaines actions toxiques ou medicamenteuses. 118p. 8? Par., Mouysset, 1929. HENRIQUES, Joao Cesar. *Estudo sobre a hereditariedade physiologica seguido de algumas consideragoes sobre hereditariedade nas doencas. 51p. 12? Lisb. [n. pub.] 1874. HENRIQUES, O. M. *Ueber Carbhamo- globin [K0benhavn] 65p. 8? Munch., J. F. Bergmann, 1929. Also Erg. Physiol, 1929, 28: 625-89. HENRIQUES, Valdemar, 1864-1936. Lundsgaard. E. lObituary] Hospitalstidende, 1936, 79. 1317-24. Also Skand. Arch. Physiol, Berl, 1937, 76: 101-8, portr. HENRIQUEZ, Enrique C, 1902- *Etude sur I'etiologie du rhumatisme articulaire aigu; les formes septiceiriiques. 120p. 8? Par., M. Lac, 1930. HENRY IV, 1553-1610. De Rilly, F. Quelques reliques du corps d'Henri IV. Aescu- lape, Par, 1934, n. ser, 24: 266-9.—Reinhard, M. Le masque de Henri IV. Ibid, 1936, 26: n. ser, 9-11. HENRY VII, 1457-1509. Paliotti, G. La salma dell'imperatore Arngo VII. Illust. med. ital, 1925, 7: 1-6. HENRY VIII, 1491-1547. Appleby. L. H. The medical life of Henry the Eighth. Manitoba M. Ass. Rev, 1934, 14: No. 3, 6-13.—FliiireL I. C. On the character and married life of Henry VIII. Internat. J. Psychoanal, Lond, 1920, 1: 24-55.—Kemble. J. Henry the Eighth; a psychological survey and a surgical explanation. Ann. M. Hist, 1931, n. ser, 3: 619-25. HENRY, of Lancaster, 1299?-1361. Le livre de seyntz medicines; the unpublished devotional treatise of Henry of Lancaster. Text, ed. by E. J. Arnould. xv, 244p. facs. 22cm. Oxf., Pub. for the Anglo-Norman text society by B. Blackwell, 1940. Anglo-Norman texts II. . . See also Arnould. E. J. F. Henry of Lancaster and his Livre des seintes medicines. 37p. 8? Manchester, 1937. HENRY, A., & BORY, L. Etudes de derma- tologie comparee. p.759-894. 8? [Par., 1936] In Nouv. prat. derm. (Darier, Sabouraud, et al) Par, 1936, 7: HENRY, Arnold K[ahlel Exposures of long bones and other surgical methods; foreword by Sir W. I. de C. Wheeler (Dublin) xii, 80p. 8? Brist., J. Wright & sons, 1927. HENRY, Augustine. Forest woods and trees in relation to hygiene. 2 p. 1. xii, 314p. illust. pl. 8? Lond., Constable & co., 1919. HENRY, Bfernard] S[tauffer] 1898- Stud- ies of yeasts and the fermentation of fruits and berries of Washington. 90p. 8? Seattle, E. N. Hutchinson [1937] HENRY, C. Bowdler. Teeth, p.5169-5223. 8? [N. Y., 1937] In Post-Grad. Surg. (Maingot, R.) N. Y, 1937, 3: HENRY, Charles, 1908- *La lutte antipaludique en Tunisie. 200p. 3 map. 8? Par., A. Legrand, 1936. HENRY, D[ero] L. Curing intestinal troubles by natural methods. 46p. illust. 8? Dallas, [1932] HENRY, Dora Priaulx, 1904- Notes on some pedunculate barnacles from the North Pacific, p.225-36. 8? Wash., 1940. Forms No. 3081, Proc. v.88, U. S. Nat. Mus. HENRY, Edward A. Editor of Doctoral dissertations accepted bv American universities. No. 7- , 1939/40- HENRY, Edward Richard, 1850- Classi- fication and uses of finger prints. 3. ed. vi, 127p. illust. pl. 3 fold. tab. 22cm. Lond., Eyre & Spottiswoode, 1905. HENRY, Frederick Porteous, 1844-1919. Henry, J. N. [Biography] Month. Bull. Philadelphia Dep. Pub. Health, 1935, 4-6. HENRY, Gabrielle Berthe, 1899- *Aper- cu sur la position a Boston en 1925-1926 du service social a l'Hopital des Enfants. 126p. 8? Par., M. Vigne, 1932. HENRY, Georges Etienne, 1900- ^'ex- portation des moutons au Maroc [Alfort] 56p. 8? Oudjda, Impr. M. Baumann, 1929. HENRY, George William, 1889- Essen- tials of psychiatry; with a chapter on psychiatric nursing, by Adele Poston [2. ed.] xiv, 304p. 8? Bait., Williams & Wilkins co., 1931. Also 3. ed. xii, 465p. 1938. ---- Essentials of psychopathology. ix, 312p. diagr. 8? Bait., W. Wood & co., 1935. HENRY, Hannah. Domestic guide; an in- valuable collection of practical recipes for the household, and remedies for the curing of all skin diseases, iv, 30p. 18? Huntington, Pa., J. L. Rupert, 1892. HENRY, Jacques, 1913- *Endom6tri- omes vesicaux. 143p. X pl. 24cm. Par., A. Lapied, 1939. HENRY, John Norman, 1873-1938. Obituary. J. Am. M. Ass, 193S, 111: 2136.—Sinkler, F. W. [Obituary] Tr. Coll. Physicians Philadelphia, 1910-41, 8: 240. HENRY, Joseph, 1799-1878. Fir«t secretary of the Smithsonian Institution. Rep. U. S Nat. Mus. (1897) 1901, pt 2, pl. 44. HENRY, Joseph, 1898- *Fonctionne- ment de la maternite de l'Hopital Boucicaut (Annee 1924) 52p. 8? Par., Le Frangois, 1926. HENRY, Jules, 1904- Jungle people, a Kaingang tribe of the highlands of Brazil, xix, 215p. diagr. 24cm. [N. Y.] J. J. Augustin [1941] HENRY, Louis. The influence of milk in the production and dissemination of disease. 20p. 8? Melbourne, Australian Health Soc, 1898. HENRY HENRY, Louis, 1S34-1913. Delacre. M. [Biography] Annuaire Acad. sc. Belgique, 1914, 80: 311-409, portr. HENRY, Lucas Smith, 1886- The mental aspect of the deafness problem with a discussion of mechanical aids. 5p. 8? Syracuse, N. Y. [n. pub., 1937?] HENRY, Maurice, 1907- Contribution a l'etude de la parathyroidectomie dans le traitement de la polyarthrite ankylosante et des rhumatismes chroniques. 269p. 8? Lyon, Bose freres, 1934. HENRY, Robert, 1878-1934. Necrologie. Bull. Soc. chir. Paris, 1934, 26: 370. —— & BUSSON, Gaston. Manuel d'uretro- scopie posterieure. 80p. 6 pl. 8? Par., Masson & cie, 1931. HENRY, Robert, & DEMONCHY, Andre. Manuel d'uretroscopie. 116p. illust. 5 pl. 24^cm. Par., Masson & cie, 1920. HENRY, Robert Wallace, 1867-1931. [Obituary] Brit. M. J, 1931, 2: 727. Also Lancet, Lond, 1931, 2: 879. HENRY, Thomas Anderson, 1873- The plant alkaloids. 3. ed. viii, 689p. 23cm. Phila., P. Blakiston's son & co., 1939. ---- SOLOMON, William, & GIBBS, Egbert M. Modified cinchona alkaloids. Pt 2: The action of sulphuric acid on quinine and quinidine. p.966-71. 8? [Bungay, Eng., R. Clay & sons] 1935. Reprinted from J. Chem. Soc, July 1935. ---- The same. Pt 4: Constitution, p.592- 601. 8? [Bungay, Eng., R. Clay & sons] 1937. Reprinted from J. Chem. Soc, Apr. 1937. HENRY, Thomas Rfobert] 1893- New- type influenza found, adding to epidemic problem. Clipping from Evening Star, Wash., Dec. 22, 1940. ---- [Arabic manuscripts] Clipping from Evening Star, Wash., March 11, 1941. HENRY, Walter, 1791-1860. Howell. W. B. Walter Henry, Army surgeon. Canad. M. Ass. J, 1937, 36: 302-10. HENRY, William Arnon, 1850- Feeds and feeding; a hand-book for the student and stockman. 12. ed. vi, 613p. 8? Madison, Wis., 1912. HENRYETTA, Okla. Report of the sanitary survey, United States Public Health Service, of the city of Henrvetta, Oklahoma, 1917. 4p. fol. [Henry- etta, Oklahoma, 1917] HENS, Erich, 1902- *Die Gefahren und Behandlung der Jochbeinfraktur. 18p. 2 1. 8° Wiirzb., H. Sturtz, 1927. HENSCHEL, August Wilhelm Eduard Theo- dore, 1790-1856. Benedict, K. H. *Die Demonstratio ana- tomica corporis animalis (Henschel) auf Grund einer Nachprufung des Breslauer handschrift- lichen Textes und eines Vergleiches mit einer Erfurter Handschrift neu herausgegeben. 39p 8? Lpz., 1920. HENSCHEL, Elias, 1755-1839. Savitz, H. A. A poem dedicated to Dr Elias Henschel. p.161-5. 8? Chic. [1939] In Med. leaves (A. Levinson) Chic, 1939. HENSCHEL, Fritz, 1906- lntersuchun- gen uber die Funktionstuchtigkeit partieller oberer Prothesen mit Hilfe des Haber'schen Gnatho-Dynamometers. 52p. 2 tab. 8° Bonn L. Xeuendorff, 1930. HENSCHEL HENSCHEL, Hans, 1899- *Die Behand- lung der peritonitischen Darmlahmung [Berlin] 23p. 8? Copenliok, Behrens & Reinicke 1927 HENSCHEN, Folke, 1881- Ueber Chris- tians Syndrom und dessen Beziehungen zur allgemeinen Xanthomatose. 93p. 8? Upps Almqvist & Wiksell, 1931. Forms Suppl. 6, v. 12, Acta pcediat. ■---- Morgagnis Syndrom; Hyperostosis fron- talis interna, Virilismus, Obesitas. 82p. 8° Jena, G. Fischer, 1937. Forms H. 39, v.9, Veroff. Konst. Wehrpath. HENSCHEN, Salomon Eberhard, 1847-1930. Klinische und anatomische Beitrage zur Patho- logie des Gehirns. 4v. pts 3-7. fol. Upps Almquist & Wiksell, 1896-22. For Festschrift see Acta med. scand, 1926-27, 65: portr Also J. Psychol. Neur, Lpz, 1929-30, 40: portr. For biography see Acta med. scand, Stockholm, 1930-31, 74: 325-33, portr (S. Ingvar) Also Acta psychiat. neur, Kbh 1931, 6: 1-3, portr (K. H. Krabbe) Also Deut. Zschr. Nervenh" 1931, 120: 111-6 (F. Schultze) Also Fin. lak. sail, hand, 193l" 73: 105-75, portr. (H. Fabritius) Also Hospitalstidende, 193l' 74: [Neur. selsk. forh.] 12-4 (H. I. Schou) Also Hygiea, Stockh ' 1930, 92: 897-910, portr. (N. Antoni) Also Sven. lak. tidn"' 1930, 27: 1693-9 (H. C. Jacobaeus) also ibid, 1931, 28'! invart. med,9-14 (G. Bergmark) See also [Autobiography] Med. Gegenwart (Grote) Lpz, 1925, 5: 35-110, portr.—Potzl, O. Ueber das Lebenswerk eines grossen Hirnforschers. Med. KUn, Berl, 1926, 22: 512-4. HENSCHER, Paul [Alfons Hermann] 1896- *Ueber Nephrolithiasis unter Beriick- sichtigung eines Falles von Nierenbeckensteinen, der sekundar ein Lungenempyem mit Urinfistel zur Folge hatte [Leipzig] 19p. 8? Oschatz, C Morgner, 1926. HENSCHKE, Heinz, 1908- *Die Patho- genese der Komplikationen bei gononhoischer Erkrankung der hinteren Harnrohre die zur Unfruchtbarkeit fiihren [Berlin] 24p. 23cm. Charlottenb., K. & R. Hoffmann, 1938. HENSE, Albin, 1910- *Zur Frage der Spontanhypoglykamie; Untersuchungen uber den Blutzuckergehalt an Stoffwechselgesunden. 33p. 20/2cm. Bonn, A. Brand, 1937. HENSEL, Bernhard, 1908- *Zehn Jahre Gonorrhoe-Behandlung. 39p. ch. 8? Konigsb. i. Pr., E. Masuhr, 1934. HENSEL, Charlotte, 1889- *Psychische Taubheit mit besonderer Berucksichtigung des Kindesalters [Berlin] 35p. 8? Charlottenb., Gebr. Hoffmann, 1926. HENSEL, Gert [Otto Joseph] 1908- *Ueber Dermoidcystome ausserhalbdesOvariums. 35p. 8? Konigsb. i. Pr., J. Raabe, 1936. HENSEL, Gunther, 1906- *Kann man besonders bei beschleunigter Blutkorperchensen- kungszeit von dem Ergebnis der Westergreen- schen Methode mehr erwarten? 13p. 8? Konigsb. i. Pr. [n. pub.] 1931. HENSEL, Heinz, 1912- *Das Os tibiale externum, erworben oder angeboren? [Berlin] 22p. 21cm. Bonn, H. Trapp, 1939. HENSEL, Hilde, 1905- *Beitrage zur Kenntnis des feineren Baues der Schilddriise der Xeunaugenlarven. 36p. 8? Berl., J. Springer, 1932. ips. Also Zschr. Zellforsch, 1932, 15: HENSEL, Siegfried, 1908- * Ueber den Indikangehalt im Serum am Ende der normalen Graviditas bei Mutter und Kind [Halle] 18p. 8? Stuttg., F. Enke, 1931. Also Zschr. Geburtsh. Gyn, 1930, 98: HENSEN, Menta, 1909- *Beitrag zur experimentellen Erzeugung der Glomerulonephri- tis [Munster] 15p. 8? Werne a. d. Lippe, F. Grube, 1935. HENSEN HENSEN, Victor, 1835-1924. Reibi«ch, J. Ein Nachruf. Schr. Naturwiss. Verein. Schl. Holstein, 1920-26, 17: 225 HENSGEN, Heinrich, 1848- Anleitung zur Desinfektion fiir den Unterrieht der Mit- glieder von Sanitatkolonnen. 2. Aufl. 23p. 16? Berl., R. Schortz, 1914. ---- Kriegs- und Gefangenschaftserlebnisse eines Arztes aus dem Feldzuge von 1870-71. 3. Aufl. 91p. 8? Heidelb., J. Horning, 1914. ---- Die Desinfektion; Leitfaden fiir Desin- fektoren, Gesundheitsaufseher und Kranken- pfleger zur Vernichtung und Beseitigung der Ansteckungsstoffe. 4. Aufl. 91p. 12? Berl. R. Schoetz, 1921. HENSHAW, David, 1795-1852. Ewe, G. E. From druggist to secretary of the Navy. J. Am. Pharm. Ass, 1935, 24: 858-61, portr. HENSHAW, E. M., HOLMAN, P., & LANG- DON, J. N. Manual dexterity; effects of train- ing, vii, 45p. 8? Lond., H. M. Stat. Off., 1933. Forms Rep. No. 67, Gr. Britain Privy Counc. Indust. Health Res. Bd. HENSKE, Marianne, 1906- *Beitrag zur Kasuistik der Enterokokken-Endocarditiden. 15p. 8? BerL, Michel, 1933. HENSLE, Walter, 1906- *Ueber das Neurinom. 27p. 8? [Heidelberg, n. pub.] 1931. Mimeographed. HENSLER, Hermann, 1912- *Die Ver- ankerungsmbglichkeiten totaler Unterkieferpro- thesen unter besonderer Berucksichtigung des Saugventilrandabdruckverfahrens [Freiburg] 27p. 8? Miinch., Kastner & Callwey, 1935. HENSLOW, George, 1835-1925. Obituary. Brit. M. J, 1926, 1: 124. HENSON, Graham E., 1874- Malaria. 8p. 22y2cn\. Jacksonville, State Bd Health [1913] HENSS, Willy, 1903- *Die chirurgische Behandlung der Zahnstellungsanomalien [Muns- ter] 16p. 8? Dortmund, T. F. Bohmer, 1932. HENTE, Arnold, 1908- *Beitrag zur Behandlung der Placenta praevia unter Beriick- sichtigung der in den Jahren 1926 bis 1934 an der Gottinger Universitats-Frauenklinik zur Beobachtung gekommenen Falle von Placenta praevia [Gottingen] 23p. 8? Bottrop, W. Postberg, 1936. HENTEL, William. *Muskeldystrophien (Beitrag zur Diagnosenstellung) [Basel] 28p. 24cm. Mulhouse, A. Knecht, 1936. HENTIG, Hans von, 1887- Ueber den Casarenwahnsinn; die Krankheit des Kaisers Ti- berius. 52p. 8? Munch., J. F. Bergmann, 1924. Forms H. 119, Grenzfr. Nervenleb. HENTING, Paul, 1886- *Das chronisch rezidivierende Erysipel und seine Beziehungen zur Elephantiasis, insbesondere des Gesichtes. 32p. 8? Miinst. i. W., Westf. Vereinsdr., 1932. HENTISBERIUS, Guilelmus, ca 1380. Regu- lae, videlicet de sensu composito et diviso. 68 1. fol. Venezia, Joannes et Gregorius de Forlivio, Mar. 15, 1491. HENTSCHEL, Anna Marie, 1911- *Un- zulangliche arztliche Feststellungen in ihrer Bedeutung fur spatere Begutachtungen in frag- lichen Unfallen [Leipzig] 30p. 23cm. Zeulen- roda, A. Oberreuter, 1936. HENTSCHEL, Christopher Carl, 1899- & COOK, Walter Robert Ivimey. Biology for medical students, xii, 618p. illust. diagrs. 8? Lond., Longmans, Green & co., 1932, Also 2. ed. xii, 664p. illust. 1937, HENTSCHEL HENTSCHEL, Fritz, 1899- lnter- suchungen uber das Angulare und das Oper- cular am Unterkiefer einiger seltener Schwanz- lurche (Urodela) 32p. tab. 8? Weende, F. Pieper, 1936. HENTSCHEL, Heinrich, 1906- *Die Hirschsprung'sche Krankheit und ihre Beziehung zum Gesetz zur Verhiitung erbkranken Nach- wuchses vom 14. Juli 1933 [Breslau] 34p. 21cm. Beuthen OS., Greif Dr., 1937. HENTSCHEL, Heinz, 1909- *Bausteine zu einer Fortfuhrung der Geschichte der Ge- burtshilfe von Siebold-Dohrn. 93p. 8? Wurzb., Gebr. Memminger, 1936. HENTSCHEL, Horstmar, 1910- *Die Verwendbarkeit der Meletta Metallhohllitze in der zahnarztlichen Prothetik [Breslau] 20p. 8? Ohlau, H. Eschenhagen, 1933. HENTSCHEN, Haschem, 1896- *Totale Ausrottung der Harnblase [Berlin] 40p. 8? Charlottenb., Gebr. Hoffman, 1930. HENTZE, Rudolf [Ludwig Wilhelm] 1876- See Jaensch, E. R, & Hentze, R. Grundgesetze der Jugendentwibklung; Erkenntnisse der Jugendanthropologie in der Ausrichtigung auf neudeutsche Erziehung. 217p. 23>£cm. Lpz, 1939. HENZ, Oswald, 1907- *Die Harnsaure- synthese im Vogelorganismus. 5: Die Desami- nierung von Aminosauren und die Verwertung des Aminostickstoffs zum Aufbau des Purinringes im Taubenorganismus. 18p. 22cm. Erlangen, K. Dores, 1935. HENZE, Heinrich, 1907- *Ueber die Pathogenese der Tuberkulose der grossen Mund- speicheldriisen und insbesondere fiber deren Verhalten bei allgemeiner Miliartuberkulose [Erlangen] 37p. 8? Ochsenfurt, Fritz & Rappert, 1930. HENZE, Ursula, 1910- *Die Bedeutung der Immediatprothese fiir die Erhaltung des Kieferkammes [Berlin] 23p. 8? Charlottenb., Gebr. Hoffmann, 1935. HENZL, Stefan, 1913- *Die Beziehungen der Hypophyse zum Kreislauf [Munchen] 12p. 8? Giinzb., K. Mayer, 1936. HENZLER, Gerhard, 1911- *Ueber das Friihaufstehen nach Gehirnerschiitterung [Er- langen] 16p. 8? Wiirzb., R. Mayr, 1937. HEON-CANONNE, Jeanne, 1906- Con- tribution a l'etude de la provocation de 1'Evacua- tion uterine par association d'agents medica- menteux et de laminaires [Paris] 47p. 8? Angers, Imp. Nouvelle, 1936. HEPAFLAVIN. See Vitamin B2 HEPAR. See Liver. HEPARIN. See also Blood coagulation, Pharmacology: Antiprothrombin; Liver, Chemistry; Phospha- tide. Jorpes, J. E. Heparin; its chemistry, physi- ology and application in medicine. 87p. 22)^cm. Lond., 1939. Wilander, O. *Studien iiber Heparin. 89p. 8? [Stockh.] 1938. Also Skand. Arch. Physiol, Berl, 1938, 81: Suppl. 15. Astrup, P. [Heparin] Ugeskr. laeger, 1941, 103: 1383-8.— Carroll, H. B. Heparin. Q. Bull. Northwest. Univ. M. School, 1942, 16: 60-4.—Ferguson, J. H, & Glazko, A. J. Heparin. J. Lab. Clin. M, 1940-41, 26: 1559-64. Also Univ. Hosp. Bull, Ann Arb, 1941, 7: 27.—Heparin. Science, 1941, 93: Suppl. 9. Also Nature, Lond, 1942, 149: 24.—Jaques, HEPARIN 584 HEPARIN I, B. Heparin. Univ. Toronto M. J, 1938-39, 16: 185-90.— Mason, M. F. Heparin; a review of its history, chemistry, physiology and cUnical applications. Surgerv, 1939, 5: (il8— 37."- Murray. D. W. G. Heparin. Diplomate, 1941, 13: 357.- New American made heparin. Hebrew M. J, N. Y, 1140. 2: 152. -Ravdin, I. S. Heparin. Am. J. M. Sc, 1941, 201: 25(9-302.—Takats, G. Heparin. J. Am. M. Ass, 1941, 117: 1378.- Tecon, R. M. L'hfiparine. Praxis, Bern, 1939, 28: 304-6.—With, S. [Heparin problems] Ugeskr. laeger, 1941, 103: 138S-9L— Wormall, A. Heparin. S. Barth. Hosp. J, Lond, 193S-39, 46: 122. ---- Chemistry. Astrup, T, & Jensen, H. B. Chemistrv of heparin. J- Biol. Chem, 1938, 124: 309-12. Also repr.—Charles, A. F, & Scott, D. A. Studies on heparin; observations on the chemistry of heparin. Biochem. J, Lond, 1936, 30: 1927-33, pl.— Charles, A. F, & Todd. A. R. Observations on the structure of the barium salt of heparin. Ibid, 1940, 34: 112-8.— Fischer. A. Die Bindung von Heparin an Eiweiss. Biochem. Zschr, 1035, 278: 133-60. ------ & Schmitz, A. Ueber die chemische Natur des Heparins; die quantitative Bestimmung • les Heparins. Zschr. physiol. Chem, 1932, 210: 129.— Glazko, A. J., & Ferguson, J. H. Inhibition of tryptases by heparin. Proc. Soc. Exp. Biol, N. Y, 1940, 45: 43-6.— Jaques. I, B. Heparinase. J. Biol. Chem, 1940, 133: 445-51. Also repr.—Jorpes, E. The chemistrv of heparin. Biochem. J, Lond, 1935, 29: 1817-30. ------ On heparin, its chemical nature and properties. Acta med. scand, 1936, 88: 427-33. ------ & Bergstrom, S. Der Aminozucker des Heparins. Zschr. physiol. Chem, 1936, 244: 253-6. ------ Heparin: a mucoitin polysulfuric acid. J. Biol. Chem, 1937, 118: 447-57. Also repr.—Lipmann, F, & Fischer, A. Zur Chemie des Heparins. Zschr. physiol. Chem, 1935, 237: 273.— Masamune, H, Suzuki, M, & Kondoh. Y. Biochemical studies on carbohydrates; heparin. J. Biochem, Tokyo, T.i40, 31: 343-50.—Schmitz. A. Ist das Heparin eine Chon- droitin polyschwefelsaure? Zschr. physio!. Chem, 1935, 236: p. i. ------ & Fischer, A. Ueber die Wirkung von Heparin auf Serumalbumin. Biochem. Zschr, 1933, 259: 53-60.— Schmitz, A., & Kiihl, L. Fortgesetzte Untersuchungen iiber Heparin; die Inaktivierung des Heparins im Blut. Zschr. physiol. Chem, 1935, 234: 212-6.—Wilander. O. Die Chemie und Phvsiologie des Heparins. Skand. Arch. Physiol, Berl, 1937, 77*: 90. ------ Complete blood analysis of heparinized blood. Acta med. scand, 1938, 94: 258-06. ---- Metabolism. Asplund. J., Borell, U, £cm. Par., 1939. Aguirre J. A, & Jorg, M. E. El problema de la hepato- esolenonraffa. Dfa med, B. Air, 1932-33, 5: 433-9.—Amorosi, O" Sul valore clinico del reperto negativo nell'epatospleno- grafia. Ann. ital. chir, 1932, 11: 383-94— Arce, M, & Arce, F. >SS HEPATOLIENOGRAPHY HEPATOLIENOGRAPHY Hepatoesplenografia. Arch, med, Madr, 1932, 35: 515-7.— Bakkc, S. N. (Hepato-lienography] Med. rev, Bergen, 1931, 48: 481-509. 10 pl.—Beckermann, F. Ueber die Hepatolieno- graphie im Rahmen der klinischen Diagnostik. Verh. Deut. Ges. inn. Med, 1939, 51. Kongr, 361-4. ------ Leber die klinische Bedeutung der Hepatolienographie. Zbl. inn. Med, 1939,60:400.------it Popken. C. Kontrastdarstellung der I/eber und Milz im Rontgenbild mit Jodsolen. Fortsch. Rontgenstrahl.. 1938, 58: 519 35.—Beltram de Heredia, P. Nuevo metodo de exploraci6n radiologica del higado y bazo. Arch, med, Madr, 1934, 37: 482-5.— Benassi. E. La spleno: e i'epatocontrattiliU studiate coll'epatosplenografia dopo inie- zione di biossido di torio colloidale. Fisiol. & med, Roma, 1935, 6: 1-21. ------ L'epatosplenografia col biossido di torio mcrita di venire completamcnte abbandonata? Radiol. med, Milano, 1939, 26: 81-98.—Berg, H. H. Zur Strahlen- diagnostik der Leber (iiber Gasftillung der Gallenwege und uber ein neues Verfahren der Hepatolienographie) Zschr. klin. Med, 1938-39, 135: 562-71.—Bernabeo. V. La epato- splenografia in talune condizioni fisiopatologiche sperimentali e le sue possibility diagnostiche. Ann. ital. chir, 1934, 13: 1 133- ">8.------ La epatosplenografia col thorotrast in varie condizioni determinate sperimentalmente. Arch. Soc. ital. chir, 1934. 10: 602.—Beutel, A. Die rontgenologische Dar- stellung von Leber und Milz mittels Thorotrast. Fortsch. Ilontgensirahl.. 1932. 46: 127. Bogetti. M, & Stoppani. F. Lepatosplenoeraha. Riv. radiol, 1932-33, 7: 107-219.— Konorino Ldaondo, ('.. Lanari, E. [et al.] Los nuevos procedi- mientos de visualizaeion radiol6gica del higado y del bazo. Prensa med indent.. l'.t31-32, 18: 161-6.—Bonorino Udaondo, t .. & Maissa. P. A. La hepato-lienograffa por las sales de torio. Reun. Soc. argent, pat. region. (1931) 1932, 7. meet, H5-105.—Businco, O. Sulla utility dell'epatolienografia negli studii anatomici. Monit. zool. ital, 1933, 44: Suppl, 234.— Carnevale-Ricci, <■- L'epatosplenografia nella cirrosi di Laennec. Arch, radiol. Nap, 19.33, 9: 343-51.—Caso. G. Ricerche istologiche sull fegato e sulla milza dopo iniezioni endovenose di thorotrast. Rinasc. med, 1933, 10: 84, ll.—Catalano, O. La epatosplenografia, nuovo studio radiologico del fegato e della milza. Rass. internaz. clin. ter, 1931, 12: 811-4.—Cerami, A. Ricerche radiografiche ed anatomo-istologiche su l'uso endovenoso dell'ossido di torio colloidale per l'epato-heno-renografia. Athena, Roma, 1936, 5: 3114. t'oelho, E„ & Saldanha, A. A hepatoesplenografia; contribuicao para o estudo radiologico do figado e do baco. Lisboa med, 1932, 9: 53-85.—Cooke, H. H. Hepatolienog- raphy; experimental study of the elimination of the contrast medium. Arch. Surg, 1934, 29: 29-41.—Crosetti, L. Un nuovo metodo di esame fisico del fegato e della milza: la epatolienografia. Gior. med. prat, 1931, 13: 551-4.—Ericksen, L. G. Demonstration of liver metastases bv means of thoro- trast. J. Iowa M. Soc, 1934, 24: 101. —;--- Roentgen visualization of the liver and spleen, with thorium dioxide sol. Ibid, 438-40.—Fervers, C. Ein Todesfall nach Thorotrast. Rontgenpraxis, 1933, 5: 207.—Gilbert. R, Junet, R, & Kadrnka, S. Comportement du foie et de la rate vis-a-vis des radiations de roentgen apr6s introduction intraveineuse de thorotrast. Acta radiol, Stockh, 1935, 16: 4-15-55, pl.—Gortan, M, & Tagliaferro, E. Considerazioni cliniche radiologiche ed isto- logiche suH'epatolienografia mediante il thorotrast. Riv. radiol, 1932-33, 7: 394-414. Guerreri D'Antona, G, & Zanetti, S. Note di fisiopatologia epatosplenica ed opacizza- zione col torio colloidale. Ann. radiol, Bologna, 1934, 8: 229-53.—Heger, F. [Hepato-lienographia with iodine] Orvos- tud. kozl, 1941, 2: 70-3.—Heggie, J. F. Hepato-lienography with thoratrast. Tr. R. Med. Chir. Soc. Glasgow, 1933, 27: 129-42.—Heuser, C. Hepatolienografia con el Torotrast 1073 a radiografia de relieve de la pared del est6mago, intestino y vejiga con la soluci6n del Umbranthor y la impregnaci6n de la pelvis renal con el Torotrast 1019 a. Sem. med, B. Air, 1932, 39: 54-62.—Hirsh, J. E, & Morton, B. F. Visualization of the liver and spleen as a diagnostic aid in abdominal condi- tions. South. M. J, 1934, 27: 683-90.—Horak, J. [Hepato- lienography] Cas. lek. Cesk, 1933, 72: 424-30, 10 pl—laco- bovici, 1, ifc Jianu, St. [Hepatosplenography with thorotrast] Rev. st. med, Bucur, 1932, 21: 1357-66.—Ismet. IHepato- splenography with intravenous injections of thorostrat] /Cskeri sihhiye mecmuasi, 1933, 62: 81-4.—Jochims, J. Unter- suchungen zur Hepato-Lienographie beim wachsenden Or- ganismus. Mschr. Kinderh, 1932, 55: 39.—Jovin, Melinte, M, & Menkes, B. [New method of radiological examination: hepato-lienography] Rev. st. med, Bucur, 1933, 22: 574-84.— Kadrnka, S. Hepatosplenographie; m6thode radiologique d'exploration du parenchyme hepatique et spienique par intro- duction intraveineuse de thorotrast, substance colloidale k base de dioxyde de thorium. Schweiz. med. Wschr, 1931, 61: 425-8. ------ L'h6patospienographie; methode radiologique d'exploration du parenchyme hepatique et spienique par introduction intraveineuse d'une substance colloidale k base de thorium, le thorotrast. J. radiol. electr, 1931, 15: 291-6. ------ Hepatosplenographie; rontgenologische Darstellung des Parenchyms der Milz und Leber durch ein neues in die Blutbahn eingebrachtes kolloidales Kontrastmittel (Thoro- trast) Fortsch. Rontgenstrahl, 1931, 45: 9-15. ------ L'hepatospienographie, nouvelle methode radiologique d'ex- ploration des parenchymes du foie et de la rate. J. radiol. electr, 1932, 16: 149-56. ------ Die Frage der Thoriuinaus- scheidung bei Milz-Leberkontrastdarstellung. Verh. Deut Rontg. Ges, 1933, 26: 37-9. ------& Gilbert, R. Hepato- splenography; roentgenologic demonstration of the parenchyma of the spleen and liver by means of a new intravenous contrast medium (thorotrast) Radiology, 1932, 18: 371 7. -Kadrnka. S, & Rossier, J. Hepatospienographies, accessoirement osteomvelographies et nephrographies experimentales Acta radiol./Stockh, 1931, 12: 369-87, 4 pl.—Lanari, E. L, Aguirre. J. M, it Jorg, M. E. La representaci6n radiologica del hfgado y del bazo por el dioxido de torio. Dfa med, B. Air, 1933-34, 6: 251.—Larru, E. Estudio experimental y clinico con el di6xido de torio sol para la hepatolienografia. An. Acad, nac med, Madr. (1935) 1936, 55: 32-57. Also An. Hosp. S. .lose Madr, 1933-34, 5: 263-84.—Lewisohn, R. Hepato-lienography with thorotrast. Surg. Gyn. Obst, 1932, 55: (18-73. biesch, E. La epato-splenografia con il Thorotrast. Riv. clin. med, 1933, 34: 555-66.—McCool, D. C, jr. Visualization of the liver and spleen. Illinois M. J, 1934, 65: 535- Martin, C. L. Estudios roentgenol6gicos del hfgado y del bazo. Rev. radiol. fisioter. Chic, 19.37, 4: 284-90. Also Am. J. Roentg, 1937, 37: 633-43.—Morhardt, P. E. L'hepatospienographie. Presse med, 1932, 40: 1695-7.—Osellatore, G, & Lenarduzzi, G. Epatosplenografia ottenuta con fini emulsioni di olio jodato. Atti Congr. ital. radiol, 1934, 11: pt 2, 234-6--Paffenhulz. \V.. & Schurmeyer, A. Aenderungen der Milz- und Lcber- grosse im Rontgenbild unter verschiedenen Kreislaufbcdin- gungen (voiliiufige Mitteilung) Klin. Wschr, 1931, 10: 2076- 8.—Parino, A. L'epatosplenografia. Radiol, med, Milano, 1933, 20: 201-38.- Pomodoro. I. G. Sul comportamento dei corpi creatinici consecutive ad iniezioni endovenose di thoro- trast. Studium, Nap,, 1933, 23: 39-41.—Popovici, D. [Radi- ography of the spleen and liver] Spitalul, 1932, 52: 74-8.— Popper, H. L, & Klein, E. Ueber Hepato-Lienographie. Munch, med. Wschr, 1931, 78: 1829.—Radt, P. Eine neue Methode zur rontgenologischen Sichtbarmachung von Leber und Milz durch Injektion eines Kontrastmittels [Hepato- Lienographie] Verh. Berl. med. Ges. (1930) 1931, 61: pt 2, 189-95.------Zur rontgenologischen Kontrastdarstellung von Leber und Milz. Verh. Deut. Ges. inn. Med, 1931, 43. Kongr., 413 -51. Also Ther. Gegenwart, 1932, 73: 348 — Kanderath. E. Anatomische Befunde nach intravenoser riioriuininjektion (Praparat Thorotrast Heyden 1073a) beim Menschen zum Zwecke der Hepatolienographie. Klin. Wschr, 1932, 11: 144—6.—Reimers, C. Zur Darstellung von Leber und Milz im Rontgenbild. Arch. klin. Chir, 1932, 173: 697-707.— Teschendorf, W. Die Rontgendiagnostik von Leber, Milz und Pankreas. Jahrb. Rontg, 1931, 2: 113-8. ----— & Schmitz, F. Rontgendiagnostik von Leber, Milz und Pankreas. Ibid, 1930, 1: 84-8.—Tighe, H. V. A note on the use of thorotrast (hepato-splenoradiography) Irish J. M. Sc, 1933, 6. ser, 203-8.—Tripoli, C. J. Histology after thorium dioxide (thorotrast) in hepatolienography. Am. J. Clin. Path, 1934,4: 212-34. ------Haam, E, & Lehman, E. B. Roentgeno- graph^ visualization of the liver and spleen in the human. Am. J. Roentg, 1932, 27: 265-6.—Vajano, D. L'epatolieno- grafia col thorotrast. Arch, radiol. Nap, 1933, 9: 57-145, 4 ch.—Vara Lopez, R. Contribucion al estudio de la hepa- tolienografia. Progr. chn, Madr, 1932, 40: 140-6. -----& Thorbeck, K. Rontgenologische Sichtbarmachung von Leber und Milz. Arch. klin. Chir, 1932, 169: 236-44.—Volicer, L. [Roentgen examination of liver and spleen] Cas. lek. 6esk, 1931, 70: 480-9, 2 pl. Also Fortsch. Rontgenstrahl, 1931, 44: 452-8.—Whitaker, P. H, Davie, T. B, & Murgatroyd. F. Hepato-lienography by the aid of thorotrast; its uses and dangers. Q. J. Med, Lond, 1933, n. ser, 2: 49-58, 4 pl — Wichmann, F. W., & Fricke, O. Methode und klinische Bedeutung der Darstellung von Leber und Milz im Rontgen- bilde. Fortschr. Rontgenstrahl, 1932, 45: 664-77.—Yater, W. M. Rate of deposition of thorotrast in the human liver and spleen. Am. J. Roentg, 1937, 38: 447-9. ----- & Otell, L. S. Hepatosplenography with thorium dioxide sol; cUnical experience with 100 patients. J. Am. M. Ass, 1933, 101: 507-14. ------ & Hussey, H. H. Hepatosplenography with stabilized thorium dioxide sol; a follow-up study of 200 patients examined over a period of 5 years. Med. Ann. Dis- trict of Columbia, 1936, 5: 241-6. Also Radiology, 1936, 27: 391-409.—Yater, W. M., & Whitmore, E. R. Histopathologic study of tissues of 65 patients injected with thorium dioxide sol for hepatosplenography. Am. J. M. Sc, 1938, 195: 198- 205, 20 pl. HEPATOLITHIASIS. See Biliary calculus, intrahepatic; Liver, Calculus. HEPATOMA. See under Liver. HEPATOMEGALY. See under Liver; also Gaucher's disease; Glycogenosis; Hepatolienal syndrome, &c. HEPATO-PANCREATIC syndrome. See also Liver, Disease; Pancreas, Disease. Bottino, S., & Lanza, G. La funzione endocrina del pancreas nelle affezioni epatiche. Gior. clin. med, 1934, 15: 249-71.— HEPATO-PANCREATIC 589 HEPATO-RENAL Cole W. H. The pancreatic-hepatic syndrome. Washington TTniv M. Alumni Q, 1940, 3: 185-7.—Eckey, P. Ueber die Mitbeteiligung des Pankreas bei Lebererkrankungen sowie pine neue Methode zur Prufung der Pankreasleistung. Zschr. ges exp. Med, 1934, 94: 726-38— Hejda. B., & Anderle, E (Disorders in external secretion of the pancreas in diseases of the liver and biliary tract] Cas. 16k. Cesk, 1932, 71: 1455-7 — Montemartini, G. Sindromi epato-pancreatiche in chirurgia. Policlinico, 1935, 42: sez. chir, 582-606.—Paraschivescu, M. (Pancreatic troubles in liver diseases] Cluj. med, 1926, 7: 274-6—Parturier, G, & Dclerue. Syndromes h6pato-pan- cr6atiques Rev. m6d. chir. mal. foie, 1934, 9: 331-87.— Sanguigno, N. II pancreas nelle malattie del fegato; ricerche sulle diastasi del sangue, delle urine e delle feci. Riforma med, 1935,51:703-13. HEPATO-RENAL syndrome. See also Edema, hepatic; Liver, Disease, and subheadings; Kidney, Disease; Nephritis; Uremia. Derot-Picquet, R. *Les h6patonephrites. 86p. 8? Par., 1936. DESFRANgois, J. C. E. *A propos d'un cas d'hepato-nephrite. 46p. 8? Par., 1934. Atucha, J. Insuficiencia hepatorenal y trastornos gas- trointestinales. Rev. espan. enferm. ap. digest, 1935, 1: 723-44.—Aubertin, C, & May-Darhovsky. Hepato-nephrite crvDtogenetique aigue suivie de nephrite chronique. Bull. Soc. med. hop. Paris, 1940, 56: 485-9.—Aubertin, E, & Mar- tinet, R. Influence de processus de nephrites, d'hepatites ou d'hepato-n6phrites experimentales de causes variees sur le taux de divers constituants azotes du serum sanguin, chez le chien. C. rend. Soc. biol, 1939, 132: 264-7.—Bernard. L, & Laederich, L. Le foie dans les affections du sein. Presse med, 1908 17: 153-5.—Blanc, H. Rein, foie et P. S. P. J. urol. med.', Par, 1930, 30: 462-4.—Bruins Slot, W. J. [Acute pyelonephritis and the hepatorenal syndrome] Ned. tschr. geneesk, 1940, 84: 2798-805.—Cornil, L, & Vague, J. Les types anatomiques des hepato-nephrites aigues. Rev. m6d. chir mal. foie, 1935, 10: 349-66.—Corrigan, G. F. Hepatorenal syndrome. Urol. Cut. Rev, 1942, 46: 182-4.—Cottet, J, & Cottet, J. Insuffisance h6pato-renale et cure de diurese. Rev. med. fr, 1939, 20: 179.—Del Raso, E. La orina en las en- fermedades hepdticas. Bol. Inst, pat, M6x, 1907-8, 2. ep, 5. 723-30—Derot, M. Hepatonephrites et syndromes hepa- torenal. Paris med, 1937, 103: 457-64. —---- & Derot- Picquet. Le syndrome humoral des hepatonephrites aigues. Gaz. med. France, 1938, 45: 899-901.—Dietel, F. G, & Polak, A Funktionszustand von Leber und Reticuloendothel nach Nephropathie. Arch. Gyn, Berl, 1933, 154: 122-8.—Doyon, Gautier, C, & Policard, A. Lesions renales determinees par 1'anemie arterielle ou I'ablation du foie. Lyon med, 1907, 109: 1021.—Dumas, A, & Barral. Hepato-nephrite avec presence de spirochetes dans les urines. J. med. Lyon, 1934, 15: 585-8.—Faltitschek, J., & Hess, L. Ueber ein hepa- torenales Syndrom. Wien. klin. Wschr, 1936, 49: 325.— Fiorenza, I. Permeability renale nelle affezioni epatiche. Riforma med, 1906, 22: 1261-6.—Fleischhacker, H. Das hepatorenale Syndrom. Wien. klin. Wschr, 1938, 51: 880-2.— Garlock, J. H, & Klein, S. H. The so-called hepato-renal syndrome. Ann. Surg, 1938, 107: 82-95.—Gilbert, A, & Lippmann, A. De l'exageration des variations quotidiennes du taux urinaire (anisurie) chez les hepatiques. C. rend. Soc. biol, 1906, 60: 994-6.—Helwig, F. C, & Schutz, C. B. A liver-kidney syndrome. Surg. Gyn. Obst, 1932, 55: 570-80. ----- A further contribution to the liver-kidney syndrome. J. Lab. Chn. M, 1935-36, 21: 264-77—Heyd, C. G. A consideration of the hepatorenal syndrome. Bull. Chicago M. Soc. 1941-42, 44: 539-41.—Hiratsuka, G. Ueber die Veranderungen der glomerularen Filtration und tubularen Ruckresorption der Niere bei Leberkrankheiten sowie bei experimentellen Leberschadigungen. Tohoku J. Exp. M, 1937, 31: 232-46.— Izar, G. Concetti generali sulla patogenesi, clinica e terapia delle epatonefriti ed epatonefrosi acute. Gazz. med. ital, 1940, 99: 81-7.—Kaplan, A. W., Fryszman, W. [et al.] [On hepato-nephritic syndrome] Polskie arch. med. wewn, 1938, 16: 455. Also Warsz. czaa. lek, 1938, 15: 301; 321.—Konchalovsky, M. P. [CUnical aspect of hepato- nephritis] KUn. med, Moskva, 1941, 19: No 6. 50-5.— Kroetz, C. Das akute hepatorenale Syndrom. Zbl. inn Med, 1938, 59: 481— Lichtman, S. S, & Sohval, A. R. Clinical disorders with associated hepatic and renal manifestations, with especial reference to the so-called hepatorenal syndrome Am. J. Digest. Dis, 1937-38, 4: 26-32—Livraga, P. L autohsi epatica in vivo; reperti isto-patologici; contributo alia cono- scenza deUa sindrome epato-renale. CUn. chir, Milano, 1SM7, 40: 817-42 — Matsumoto. S. Studies on the uric acid-excreting function of the Uver in renal disturbances; experiment in the case when the kidneys are mechanicaUy disturbed. Jap. J. Gastroenter, 1935, 7: 1-6. - Experiment in cases of renal disturbances provoked by drugs. Ibid, /-». Experiment by perfusion of the Uver of a rabbit. Ibid., 9-1. 1. Moustardier, G, & Vague, J. Les hepatonephrites aigues en pathologie tropicale. Marseille med, 1938, 75: pt 2 261-78 — Muller, R. Hepatorenale Insuffizienz. Prakt. Arzt, 1Mb, u. F, 21: 635-40.—Nonnenbruch. Das hepatorenale Syndrom und die Hyposthenurie N. Khn. Wschr, 1939, 18: 917-9. Also Verh. Deut. Ges. inn. Med, 1939, 51. Kongr, 341-58. ------• Hepatorenal syndrome and salyrgan. J. Am. M. Ass 1942, 118: 850 (Abstr.)—Olivi, G. SuUe frazioni dell'azoto epatico nella soppressa funzione renale. Atti Soc. ital. pat 1906, 4: 374-6.—Olmer, D, & Vague, J. Etude clinique des hepato-nephrites aigu.es. Rev. med. chir. mal. foie, 1935, 10: 337-48.—Orr, T. G, & Helwig, F. C. Is there a hepatorenal syndrome? Surgery, 1940, 7: 136. ------ The hepatorenal syndrome. In Lahey Birthday Vol, 1940, 339-19.—Otomo, T. Die klinischen Studien iiber die akute Hepatopathie; iiber die klinischen Symptome der Nieren und uber der Rachenkatarrh- Leidenden; Anhang: Pathogenetische Klassifikation der Patienten der akuten Nephritis. J. Orient. M, Dairen, 1939, 31: 64-8.— Pasteur, Vallery-Radot, J. L, & Derot, M. Le syndrome hepato-renal aigu. Rapp. Congr. insuff. ren, 1938, 2. Congr, 463-81. ------ A propos des hepatonephrites aigues. In Libro de oro M. R. Castex, B. Air, 1939, 3: 1410-6.—Poli, E, & Toffanelli, G. Sulle cosidette sindromi epatorenali. Clin. med. ital, 1939, 70: 489 503.-Pytel, A. J. [Hepato-renal syndrome] KUn. med, Moskva, 1936, 14: 838-54. ------ Zur Frage des hepato-renalen Svndroms. Arch. kUn. Chir, 1936, 187: 27-48. ------ [('iinical characteristics of the hepatorenal syndrome] Medicina, Kaunas, 1936, 17: 633-40. Also Urol. Cut. Rev, 1937, 41: 307-10. Also Wien. kUn. Wschr, 1937, 50: 965-8. -----■ [Classification and clinical characteristics of the hepato-renal syndrome; hepato-nephritis] Stalingrad, gosud. med. inst, 1939, i: 99-112.—Richardson, H. The urine in hepatic disease. Hosp. Bull. Univ. Maryland, 1905, 1: 61.—Rosenbaum, J. Ein Beitrag zum Problem dea entero-hepato-renalen Syndroms (Anurie nach Leberschadi- gungen) Deut. Zschr. Chir, 1934, 243: 66-84.—Roth, I. [Syndrome of hepato-renal insufficiency in porphyrinuria] Orv. hetil, 1937, 81: 961-3.—Roucayrol, P. E. CompUcations genito-urinaires de rinsuffisance hepatique meconnue. C. rend. Congr. internat. insuff. hepat, 1937, 1. Congr, 427-31.— Rufanov, I. G. [Hepato-renal syndrome] Sovet. khir, 1933, 4: 391-400.—St. Jacques, E. The hepatorenal syndrome; treatment. J. Internat. Coll. Surgeons, 1939, 2: 295-7.— Sakamoto, A, Saito, H. [et al.] Ueber Hepatonephritis acuta endemica. Jap. J. M. Sc, 1938-39, 5: Int. Med, 53-5.— Schnedorf, J. G, & Orr, T. G. The effect of distention of the small intestine, anoxemia and oxygen therapy upon the flow of bile and urine in the dog; relationship to the hepatorenal syndrome. Surg. Gyn. Obst, 1942, 74: 446-8.—Steinberg, J. Kidney-liver syndrome. Urol. Cut. Rev, 1936, 40: 494-6.— Toro, N. Studio della sindrome epatorenale negU animali sani e in quelli privati di un rene. Ann. ital. chir, 1937, 16: 313- 40.—Trillot, J, & Raucoules, P. Traitement par l'orthosiphon stamineus de certaines psychoses Uees k l'insuffisance hepato- renale. Ann. med. psychol. Par, 1937, 95: 452-5.—Tsuji, S. Supplementary contributions to the clinical information about hepatorenale Erkrankungen. Jap. J. Gastroenter, 1939, 11: 147-51.—Uebelhor, R. Die hepatorenale Storung. Wien. kUn. Wschr, 1937, 50: 115; 155.—Vague, J. Les hepatone- phrites aigues benignes. Ann. med. Par, 1938, 43: 360-79. ------ & Bosch. A. Hepatonephrites aigues et anaphylaxie. Marseille med, 1937, 74: pt 2, 7; 49; 97.—Varela Fuentes, B. Acerca de la naturaleza de las hiperazoemias que complican las afecciones agudas hepatobiliares. Dfa med, B. Air, 1940, 12: 1105-9.—Vauthey, M. Etudes sur l'intol6rance hepatique aux agents chimiques; vue d'ensemble sur la part du foie dans les hepato-nephrites d'origine chimique. Ann. mal. v6ner, 1938, 33: 81-5.—Wilensky, A. O. Occurrence, distribution and pathogenesis of so-called Uver death and/or the hepatorenal syndrome. Arch. Surg, 1939, 38: 625-91. Also repr.— Zagarese, F. Contributo sperimentale aUa conoscenza della sindrome epato-renale. CUn. chir, Milano, 1934, n. ser, 10: 1101-14.—ZHocchi, E, & Marini, A. Ricerche sperimentali sulla sindrome epato-renale. Arch. sc. med. Tor, 1939, 67: 607-48.—Zuidema, P. J, & Waart, A. de [Transitory auricular fibriUation and bundle-block in a patient with hepato-renal syndrome] Geneesk. tschr. Ned. Indie, 1941, 81: 486-96, pl. HEPATOSPLENOMEGALY. See also Cholesterosis, visceral; Gaucher's disease; Hepatolienal syndrome; Reticulo-endo- theliosis. Batemen, D. FamiUal hepato-splenomegaly: 2 cases occur- ring in brothers. Proc. R. Soc. M, Lond, 1934, 27: 1327 — Castronuovo, G. EpatosplenomegaUe tropicah ed egiziane. Riforma med, 1935, 51: 1793-5.—Ellis, R. W. B. Hepato- splenomegaly with mental deficiency and bone changes. Proc. R Soc. M, Lond, 1934, 27: 1022-5.—Hamilton, R. L & ADDel J Z Present day conception of hepato-splenomegaha. Bull. Guthrie CUn, 1933, 2: 123731■—KUw I & Faits, K. [Spleno-hepatomegaha osteosclerotic^,] Orv. hetil, 1940, 84: 336 —Lange, C. de [On large spleens and large livers] Geneesk. bl 'l939 36: 295-377.—Melli, G. Epato-splenomegahe con ittero. Policlinico, 1933, 40: sez. med, 69-127, 6 pl.—Mona- sters, G. SuUa epato-splenomegaha egiziana. Arch. 1st. biochem. ital, 1934, 6: 311-40, pl.—Poynton, F. J, Lightwood R C & Ellis, R. W. B. Hepatosplenomegaly with mental deficiency and bone changes. Proc. R. Soc. M, Lond, 1934, 27- 1025-8—Serra, G. La epato-splenomegaha egiziana. Mem. Accad. ItaUa, 1930, No. 2,1: biol, 1-102, 6 pl —Stransky. E Ueber grosszellige Splenohepatomegahe. Jahrb. Kinderh., 1929-30, 3. F, 76: 204^10. HEPATOZOIDAE 590 HEPP HEPATOZOIDAE. See also Erythrocytozoon; Haemogregarinidae; Leukocytozoon; also Rhiphicephalus. Franchini, G, & Poggi, I. Su di alcune ricerche in riguardo alia Leucocitogrcgarina; Hepatozoon ratti (Adie) Arch. ital. sc. med. col, 1927, 8: 126-30.—Lavier, G, & Callot, J. Hepa- tozoon burneti n. sp, hemogregarine parasite de Tarentola mauritanica. Arch. Inst. Pasteur Tunis, 1938, 27: 444-9.— Perez Ara, A. Primer reporte sobre el Hepatozoon muris en ratas de Cuba. Rev. med. cir. Habana, 1936, 41: 273-89.— Robin, A. Cycle evolutif d'un Hepatozoon de Gecko verti- cillatus. Ann. Inst. Pasteur, Par, 1936, 56: [376-94.—Sassu- chin, D. Grahamia und Hepatozoon-Blutparasiten der Nager Im Sud-Osten RSFSR; vorlaufige Mitteilung. Arch. Protistenk, 1931,74:523-9. HEPBURN, David, 1859-1931. [Obituary] Brit. M. J, 1931, 1: 517. HEPBURN, Herbert, 1902- *Ist die Kieferhohe Rasseneigentiimlichkeit? [Leipzig] 20p. 8? [Zeulenroda, A. Oberreuter, 1930] HEPBURN, Joseph Samuel, 1885- Medi- cal annals of the Central High School of Phila- delphia, with a historical sketch of medical educa- tion in Philadelphia. 94p. 8° Phila., Mary Gaston Barnwell Found., 1940. Forms No. 72, v.18, BarnweU BuU. See also Pearson, WilUam Alexander, & Hepburn, Joseph S. Physiological and clinical chemistry. 2. ed. 467p. 8° Phila, 1938. HEPDING, Ludwig, 1912- *Beitrage zur Aetiologie und Diagnostik der ansteckenden Huhnerlahmung [Giessen] 58p. 5 tab. 8? Boehum, H. Poppinghaus, 1936. HEPINEUZE, Jean, 1909- *Les chancres syphilitiques grants de la joue. 59p. 8? Par., Libr. Le Francois, 1937. HEPLER, J[esse] R[aymondl 1886- See Marsden, H. A, jr, Clapp, H. S. [et al.] Your home grounds month by month. 39p. 8? Durham, 1938. Also Phillips, T. G, Smith, T. O. [et al.] Some effects of potassium and nitrogen on the composition of the tomato plant, lip. 8°. Durham. 1939. ----& ELLIS, Elizabeth. Tomatoes for good health. 8p. 8? Durham, N. H., 1939. Forms Circ. 220, Univ. N. Hampshire Extens. Serv. HEPLER, Opal Eflsie] 1899- Manual of laboratory methods in clinical pathology, North- western University Medical School, v, 72 1- roy. 8? Ann Arb., Mich., Edwards bros, 1935. ---- Manual of clinical laboratory methods, Northwestern University Medical School. 98 1. tab. roy. 8? Chic, J. S. Swift co., 1937. HEPNER, Franz, 1903- *Zur Frage der Antikorperbildung in der Haut [Leipzig] p.358- 71. 8? Jena, G. Fischer, 1926. Also Zbl. Bakt, 1. Abt, 1926, 100: HEPP, Elisabeth, 1904- *Menstruation und Leibesiibungen. 13p. 8? Kiel, Dr Kieler Ztg, 1929. HEPP, Gunther, 1909- *Die Operation der atrophischen und hypertrophischen Hange- brust; eine Kritik samtlicher Verfahren. 18p. 8? Munch., C. Wolf & Sohn, 1935. HEPP, Jacques Gilbert, 1905- *La lipoidose vesiculate. 239p. 8? Par., L. Arnette, 1934. HEPP, Josef, 1908- *Ein Beitrag zur Frage der essentiellen Thrombopenie [Tubingen] 30p. 8? Marbach, A. Remppis, 1932. HEPP, Joseph, 1907- *Ueber die Wir- kung des Propylacetats. 16p. 8? Wiirzb. [n. pub.] 1931. HEPP, Liesel, 1911- * Versuche iiber das Verhalten von Atropin im Korper von Post- Encephalitikern. 19p. 8? Tub. [n. pub.] 1934. HEPP, Oskar [Ernst August] 1910- *Physiologie und Pathologie der Thrombocyten- agglutination in Schwangerschaft und Wochen- bett unter besonderer Berucksichtigung der Thrombosebereitsehaft [Kiel] 23p. 8? Quaken- bruek, R. Kleinert, 1935. HEPP Dubiau, Jean. *Funci6n andr6gena; estudio bio-qufmico del nucleo del androstano [Chile] 31p. 26}£cm. Santiago, Imp. El Imparcial, 1940. HEPPE, Otto, 1903- *Ueber die Be- einflussung des Blutzuckers durch Milzhormon p.209-22. 8? Jena, Springer, 1931. Also Zschr. ges. exp. Med, 1931, 78: HEPPE, [Wilhelm] Otto, 1899- *Ueber einen Fall doppelseitiger Orbitalphlegmone im Anschluss an ein Hordeolum. 15p. 8? Mar- burg [n. pub.] 1926. HEPPE, Wolfgang, 1910- *Aehnlich- keiten und Unterschiede an Zwillingsgebissen [Heidelberg] 17p. 8? Walldorf, F. Lamade, 1935. HEPPES, Gertrud, 1909- *Ueber die therapeutischen Wirkungen der Calcium-Diuretin- Praparate. 31p. 8? Heidelb., Brausdruck, 1934. HEPPES, Liselotte, 1911- *Die Rein- fusion des Blutes bei Extrauteringraviditat [Heidelberg] 14p. 21cm. Wertheim, E. Bech- stein, 1936. HEPPNER, Karl, 1903- *Zur Kenntnis des isolierten Lichen ruber planus der Mund- schleimhaut. 29p. 8? [Frankf. a. M., n. pub.] 1930. HEPTANE. See Hydrocarbon. HEPTIA, Edmond, 1904- *A propos d'un cas de kystes hydatiques multiples de l'abdomen; considerations chirurgicales. 98p. 4 pl. 8? Par., Jouve & cie, 1932. HEPTING, Harald, 1912- *Ueber unreife maligne Sympathicusgeschwiilste. 17p. 8? Wurzb., R. Mayr, 1937. HERACLEUM. See also Umbelliferae. Leclerc, H. Les remedes des champs et des bois: la berce (Heracleum sphondyUum L.) Presse med, 1926, 34: 1134. HERAEUS, W. C, ed. Alba, das Ergebnis einer Forschung; Beitrage zur Kenntnis der Edelmetalle als Werkstoffe in der Zahnheilkunde. 135p. illust. 21cm. Lpz., O. Spamer, 1938. HERAKLEIDES, of Pontus, 4. cent. B. C. Ilept wokntuv [ed. Cam. Perusio] p.73-8. 8? Venezia [1545] See Orelianus. IIoikiXtjs loropias letc] Venezia, 1545. HERAKLEITOS, of Ephesus, fl. 504 B. C. 'ETTto-roXm. p.288b-293b. 8? Venezia, 1499. See Collect, epist. Graec. Venezia, 1499. HERALD of health and naturopath. N. Y., v.24-27, 1919-22. HERALDRY. See also Caduceus; Symbolism. Bennett, A. B. The emblems of medicine. Week. BuU. S. Louis M. Soc, 1937-38, 32: 296-8.—Bourchenin, M. D. Le blason interconfessionnel en France. Rev. anthrop. Par, 1931, 41: 269; 1932, 42: 55; 279; 438; 1933, 43: 439.—Gardner. L. L. The head of Minerva. Army M. Bull, 1942, No. 60, 116-21 — Jennings, H. Mystische christUche Figuren und Talismane. In his Rosenkreuzer, Berl, 1912, pt 1, 16.5-75. ----- Rosenkreuzerisches in alten Mysterien; rosenkreuzerische Spuren in den Orden der Ritterschaft nachweisbar. Ibid, pt 2, 30-45.—Klanfer, J. Theorie der heraldischen Zeichen. Arch. ges. Psychol, 1935, 94: 413-45.—Nuestro emblema. Rev. med, S. Jose, 1940-41, 4: 425.—Rumsey, H. St J. Some notes on English heraldry. Guy's Hosp. Gaz, Lond, 1937, 51: 526-9. HERARD 591 HERB HERARD, Hippolyte, 1819-1913. Rist, E. [Biography] Bull. Acad, med. Par, 1936, 3. ser, 116: 527-41, portr. HERARD, Marcel, 1900- Considera- tions sur le traitement par la chirurgie des epitheliomes cutanes du nez, anterieurement irradies. 82p. 8? Par., M. Vigne, 1929. HER AUX, Andre, 1893- *Les broncho- pneumonies ou pneumonies en foyers chez l'enfant. 122p. 8? Par., Masson & cie, 1929. See also Metzger, Marcel, & Heraux, Andre. Les premiers jours du nouveau-ne. 444 p. 8? Par, 1931. HERB, Ferdinand, 1866- Female dis- eases, their prevention and cure; a popular- scientific treatise of all diseases peculiar to women with full directions for self-treatment. 286p. 8? Superior, Wis., Herb-Mussgang Pub. co., 1896. --- Care-feeding of the baby; a handbook for mothers, midwives and nurses, xv, 267p. 8! Superior, Wis., R. & S. Pub. co., 1907. --- Gonorrhea and sexual debility in men. 228p. 8? Superior, Wis., R. & S. Pub. co., 1908. HERB. See also Drug, vegetable; Gramineae; Medi- cine, popular; Plant, medicinal. Barili, P. L'erba medica; sua coltura, sua importanza tecnica ed economica. 175p. 16? Milano, 1929. Fidi, A. Erbe e piantre medicinali. 2. ed. 355p. 8? Milano, 1934. Henkel, A. Weeds used in medicine. 45p. 8? Wash., 1904. Coleman, E. Kipling's herbs. Australas. J. Pharm, 1940, n. ser, 21: 655-7.—M'Kee, E. S. Medical weeds. Lancet- CUnic, Cincin, 1906, n. ser, 57: 86-8.—Marzell, H. Der Zauber der Heilkrauter in der Antike und Neuzeit. Sudhoffs Arch, 1936, 29: 3-26.—Moucka, V. Mikroskopische Unter- suchung der Fruhlingskrauter. Zschr. Untersuch. Lebensmitt, 1936, 71: 58; passim.—Soriano, A. L. Herbolario practices. Rev. fiUp. med, 1940. 31: 229-34.—Thezee. Herborisation aux etangs de Chaumonti Arch. med. Angers, 1906, 10: 520; 544.—Triplett, A. T. Gravel weed. Eclect. M. J, Cincin, 1934,94:462. --- Cultivation, and collection. De Baroni, G. Giardino medicinale [new ed.] [16]p. 18? Verona, 1595. Anlage (Die) von Heilkrautergarten an KUniken. Deut. Heilpflanze, 1935-36, 2: 74r-6.—Bcguinot, A. Sulla opportunity di disciplinare l'industria deUa erboristeria in Italia. Arch. chim. farm, Roma, 1918, 7: 137-50.—Coleman. E. Herb- growing as a hobby. Australas. J. Pharm, 1939, n. ser, 20: 763-5. ------ Physic gardens, past and present; medicines, magic and therapeutic. Ibid, 954-6. - - _Herb growing for personal profit. Ibid, 1940, 21: 805; 730; 874-6. Herb growing in a national emergency; herbs of power. Ibid, 1941, 22: 140-2.—Cultivation of herbs. Lancet, Lond, 1940, 2: 315.—Deegener, H. Die Diingung von Arznei-, Gewiirz- und Duftpflanzen. Deut. Heilpflanze, 1936-37, 3: 89-91 — Deutschlands Heil- und Gewiirzpflanzenanbau 1938. Ibid, 1938-39, 5: 33.—Herb prospects. Lancet, Lond, 1940, 2: 142.—Lucass. Die Anlage von Heilkrautergarten in Kran- kenanstalten. Zschr. ges. Krankenhauswes, 1936, 335.— Medicinal herbs in wartime. J. Am. M. Ass, 1941, 117: 948.—Mockel, W. Heil- und Gewiirzpflanzen im Anstalts- garten. Psychiat. neur. Wschr, 1939, 41: 516.—News from Germany; harvesting of medicinal herbs in 1941. J. Am. M. Ass, 1941, 117: 213.—Vom Sammeln, Trocknen und Aufbe- wahren der Krauter. Deut. Heilpflanze, 1935-36, 2: 99 — Wellcome, H. S. The WeUcome materia medica farm; a modern physic garden. In his Anglosax. Leechcraft, Lond, 1912, 101-7.—Windisch, A. Erfahrungen und Anregungen zur Heilkrautersammlung durch die Schuljugend. Deut. Heil- pflanze, 1940, 6: 17. ■--- Ecology. Da Gratjno, A. Piante ed erbe medicinali della regione Tridentina. 3. ed. 253p. 8? Trento, 1937. Meijer, A. S. C. *Bijdrage tot de Kennis der Volksgenees-Kruiden van Nederlandsch West- Indie. 77p. 8? Utrecht, 1932. Eddelbuttel, H. In Rostock zur Zeit des Dreissigjahrigen Kneges vorkornmende Heilkrauter und Zierpflanzen der ™r.t?1)' Sudhoffs Arch, 1938, 31: 86; 121.—McKee, E. S. Medicinal weeds in America. Gaillard's South. Med, 1906, 85: 57-61.—-Trebing. Deutsche Heilkrauter an Stelle von Senega und Ipecacuanha. Ther. Gegenwart, 1923, 64: 158.— Yeatts, H. B Medicinal herbs of the Argentine. Med. Bull. (Standard OU Co.) N. Y., 1935-36, 2: 267-70. ---- Pharmacology. Kubrich [F.] W. *Untersuchungen iiber den Vitamingehalt eines Wildkrauterpraparates. 43p. 23cm. Lpz., 1937. Grimaldi, A. Indagini sui semi di erba medica di diversa provenienza. Riv. biol, 1937, 22: 442-56, ch.—Heun, E. Anwendung und Erfolge der Pflanzenrohsaftekur. Naturarztl. Rdsch, 1937, 9: 295-305.—Loftier, E. R. Die Krautersaft- kuren und deren Anwendung; nebst einem Anhang uber Krau- termolken. Hippokrates, Stuttg, 1939, 10: 251; 367; 434; 470; 495; 525.—Valore (II) degli ortaggi neU'aUmentazione. Riv. Soc. ital. igiene, 1938, 60: 196-8.—Weiss, R. F. Herba an- serinae als Antispasmodicum. Hippokrates, Stuttg, 1938, 9: HERBAL (An) [1525] See Larkey, S. V, & Pyles, T, eds. An herbal [1525] 37 1. 86p. 23^cm. N. Y, 1941. HERBAL. See also Drug, History. Amsler, H. *Ein handschriftlicher illustrier- ter Herbarius aus dem Ende des 15. Jahrhunderts und die medizinisch-botanische Literatur des Mittelalters [Zurich] 95p. 8? [Herzogen- buchsee, 1924] Askham, A. A little herball of the properties of herbes; newly amended and corrected, wyth certayn additions at the ende of the boke. 79 1. 15 x 21cm. [Lond.] 1550. Boke (A) of the propertyes of herbes the whiche is called an herbal. 77 1. 16 x 21}^cm. [Lond., 1539] Gerard, J. Gerard's Herball; the essence thereof distilled by Marcus Woodward from the edition of Th. Johnson, 1636. 303p. 8? Lond., 1927. Hellriegel, H. *Die Practica aus dem Micrologus Richards des Englanders [Leipzig] 64p. 23cm. Zeulenroda, 1934. I., H. Een kleynen herbarium, ofte kruyt-boecx- ken, inhoudende de kracht, ende operatie van alle de ghemeene kruyden ende lekende vruchten die men dagelijcke gebruyckt, waer deur men mit Gods hulpe een yeder sijne gesontheyt kan onderhouden, ende veelderhande sieckten gene- sen. 196p.? 24? Dordrecht, 1660. Klebs, A. C. Herbals of the fifteenth century. 35p. 24^cm. [n. p.] 1918. La Cruz, M. de. The Badianus manuscript (Codex Barberini, Latin 241) Vatican Library; an Aztec herbal of 1552. 341p. 31cm. Bait., 1940. Landgraf [0.] E. *Ein fruhmittelalterlicher Botanicus. 36p. 8? Lpz., 1928. Leclerc, H. Le petit jardin (Hortulus) de Walahfrid Strabus; texte Latin et traduction francaise, prec6d6s d'une etude sur la vie et sur les ceuvres poetiques de l'auteur et accompagnes de commentaires. HOp. 12? Par., 1933. Wengle, K. *Die Pflanzenbiicher des 16. Jahrhunderts als Spiegelbild der damaligen Anschauungen und Zustande im Aerztestand. 39p. 8? Zur., 1926. Arber, A. An Aztec herbal. Nature, Lond, 1940, 145: 81-3. ------ The colouring of 16th century herbals. Ibid, 803.—Aztec (An) herbal. Lancet, Lond, 1940, 2: 427.— Brown, T. E. B. Herbals and herbaria. Ther. Soc. Tr, Lond, 1905, 3: 85-90.—Emmart, E. W. Herb medicine of the Aztecs. J. Am. Pharm. Ass, 1937, 26: 42-5.—Garrison, F. H. Herbals and bestiaries. Bull. N. York Acad. M, 1931, 2. ser, 7: 891- 904.—Hommel. F. Zu den QueUen der altesten Krauterbucher. In Festschr. z. 70. Geburtst. Alexander Tschirch, Lpz, 1926, 72-9.—Hummel, A. W. The printed herbal of 1249 A. D. HERBAL 592 HERBALISM Isis, Menasha, 1941, 33: 439-42.—Jarcho, S. Four detached leaves from a 16th centurv herbal, Lawrens Andrewe's Vertuose boke of distyllacyon. Ann. M. Hist, 1940, 3. ser, 2: 203- 14.—Johnston-Saint, P. Deux herbiers manuscrits du XV" S. au Musee WeUcome de Londres. Aesculape, Par, 1938. 28: 244-50.—Kroeber, I, Krauterbilcher in alter und neuer Zeit. In Festschr. z. 70. < nsburtst. Alexander IVehirch, Lpz, 1926, 108-20.—Marzell. H. Alte deutsche Krauterbiicher. Hippo- krates, Stuttg, 1030, 7: 409-15.—Masson, I, Le Livre des Plantes de Tragus. Aesculape, Par, 1934, n. ser, 24: 301-10.— Montebaur, J. Ein siiddeutsches Herbarium in der Vati- kanischen Bibliothek. Arch. Gesch. Naturwiss, 1928-29, 11: 271-6.—Simonini, R. Herbolarium et materia medica Codice Ms. n. 296 della Bibliotccu Governativa di Lucca. Pass. clin. ter, 1936, 35: Suppl., 208; 321.—Sprague, T. A. Earlv herbals. Pharm. J, Lond, 1037, 85: 515-8.—Wellcome, H. S. The Herbarium of Apuleius Platonicus. In his Anglosax. Leech- craft, Lond, 1912, 49-57, facsim.—Zimmermann, W. Das Anfangsherbarium des Hieronymus Harder. In Vortr. Ges. Gesch. Pharm. (Germany) Mittenwald, 1936, 17-54. HERBALISM [and herbalist] See also Herb; Naturopathy; Phytotherapy; Plant, medicinal. Bell, J. \Y. Nature's remedies; a popular treatise on the chemistry of herbs, their curative powers and use in cosmetics, culinary prepara- tions, wine and liqueurs, etc. 71p. 8? Lond., 1936. Budge, E. A. T. \Y. The divine origin of the craft of the herbalist. 96p. 8? Lond., 1928. Culpeper, N. Selections from the English Physitian. 32p. 8? Lond. [1929] Deutsche (Die) Heilpflanze. Stollberg i. Erzgeb., 1: 1934-35. Ellis, Mrs. J. D. Herbs used in medicine. 32p. S? Lond., 1917. Harper-Shove, F. Prescriber and clinical repertory of medicinal herbs. 199p. 19cm. [Lond., 1938] Hertwig, H. Gesund durch Heilpflanzen; altes und neues Wisscn vom Kampfe der Pflanze gegen die Krankheit und von ihrer Kraft mensch- liehes Scliieksal zu gestalten. 3. Aufl. 300p. 8? Berl. [1937] Larsen, J. A. The practical herbalist. 244p. 16? Seattle, 1922. Mausert, O. Herbs for health [3. ed.] 205p. 19^cm. S. Franc. [1940] Mertes, P. Fiinfhundert Heilpflanzen mit besonderer Berucksichtigung der Kneippschen Krauter-Heilmethode, der deutschen Obst-, Ge- miise- und Salatpflanzen. 6. Aufl. 181p. 8? Ravensburg [1936] Meyer, J. E. The herbalist and herb doctor. 399p. 16? Hammond, Ind. [1932] Muller, F., & Koch, C. Das grosse illu- strierte Krauterbuch; praktisches Handbuch der Pflanzenkunde unter besonderer Beriicksichti- gung der Verwendung von Pflanzen als Heil- mittel. 10. Aufl. 952p. 8? Ulm, 1937. Sheppard, J. T., sr & Sheppard, J. T., jr. Grandmother's remedies; a dictionary of me- dicinal herbs and their uses including many Dutch and Indian remedies. [144]p. 8? Johnstown, Pa. [1934] Ward, H. Herbal manual; the medicinal, toilet, culinary and other uses of 130 of the most commonly used herbs. 132p. 8° Lond. [1936] Auerbach. S. M. HerbaUsts and other charlatans J Social Hyg, 1931, 17: 270-83.—Bancroft, H. Herbs, herbals' herbaUsts: some sketches from the history of medical botany m the Old World (reprinted from the Scientific Monthly) Am. J. Pharm, 1936, 108: 448-64.—Buss, O. Einige Worte zur Heilkrauterpropaganda. Med. Welt, 1939, 13: 711-5__ Fischler, F. Was darf die Heilkunde von einer Wiederbelebung der Pflanzentherapie erwarten? Deut. Heilpflanze, 1936, 3: 20; 33.—Flamm. S. Zur Krauterheilkunde. Hippokrates Stuttg.. 1930, 7: 375-7.— Fong Wang, the Chinese herbalist' J Am. M. Ass, 1940. 115: 1566.—Griffith, I. The renaissance of botanical medicine. Am. J. Pharm. 1929 101- 79-81 .Also in his Lobscows, Phila, 1939, 312-5— Harembski W [Present day problems of herb remedies| Med. prakt, Poznaii 1936, 10: 67-70. -Herbola-Hindu health herbs hokum j' Am. M. Ass., into. Ill: 20IS.- Herb Spirit (The) healeth; plant drugs of I'nited Slates Indians. Clin. Excerpts, 1041, I5:' 67-76.—Indian herbalist and specialist; court orders return of money. Australas. J. Pharm, 1020, n. ser, 10: 909.__ Kahnt, K. Meine Krauterbehandlung. Fortsch. Med, 1935 53: 214.—Lion Cross herb tea or Lion (toss tea; a wonder of nature declared a fraud. J. Am. M. Ass, 1936, 107: 147.— I.rischer, M. Krauterkunde im Unterricht. Deut. Heil- pflanze, 1940, 6: 57-61.---Mader, E. Arzt ohne Apotheke Miinch. med. Wschr.. 1037, 84: 1053; 1092.—Medical (A) herbalist. Brit. M. J, 1910, 2: 1476.—Meyer, W. Heil- krauter im Volksgebrauche des vorigen Jahrhunderts. Natur- iirztl. Rdsch, 1939, 11: 224-8—Muszynski. J. [Plant remedies and the so-called herb cures] Med. prakt, Poznafi, 1934, 8: 131-44.—Neuhoff. W. Der biologische Lehrausfnig im Dienste der Heilkrauterbeschaffung. Deut. Heilpflanze, 1940, 6: 77.—Ointment sold at exorbitant price [Chinese] herbalist fined £75. Australas. J. Pharm, 1941, 22: 840.—Ostermann, M. One year of radioherb therapy for rheumatism, neuralgias' &c. Ars. medici, Wien, 1935, 13: 303-7.—Peters, K. Die Bedeutung von Volksbrauch und Volksglauben fiir die Kriiuter- heilkunde. Gesundh. & Erzieh, 1935, 48: 67-73.—Smolny, E. Das Krauterheilverfahren nach Maria Schlenz. Fortsch Med, 1936, 54: 193-6.—Zabel, W. Die Pflanzenheilkunde ini Rahmen der biologischen Medizin. Deut. Heilpflanze, 1934-35 1: 64. HERBARIUS Moguntinus [Aggregator Passa- vinus] 174 1. 4? [Passau, Johannes Petri 1485] HERBART, Johann Friedrich, 1776-1841 A text-book in psychology; an attempt to found the science of psychology on experience, meta- physics, and mathematics; transl. from the original German by Margaret K. Smith, xiv, 200p. 12? N. Y., D. Appleton & co., 1891. HERBER, Arthur, 1905- *Haufigkeit und Formenkreis von Hauterscheinungen bei gleichzeitiger Wurmerkrankung [Breslau] 35p. 21cm. Ohlau, H. Eschenhagen, 1937. HERBER, Harry A. [ ] *The valua- tion of the tetraiodophenolphthalein test in gall bladder pathology [Marquette Univ.] 19p. 4? Milwaukee, 1930. Typewritten. HERBERG, Erika, 1911- *Krebsbe- kampfung und Kurpfuschertum. 20p. 8? Berl, F. Linke [1938] HERBERG, Heinz Peter, 1908- *Die Utero-Placentargefasse bei Makaken [Berlin] p. 1-16. 8? Lpz., Akad. Verb Ges., 1935. Also Zschr. mikr. anat. Forsch, 1934, 37: HERBERHOLD, Theo, 1910- *Die arzt- liche Versorgung der Provinz Westfalen unter besonderer Berucksichtigung des offentlichen Gesundheitswesens. 30p. 23cm. Munster (Westf.) O. Kiesser, 1937. HERBERMANN, Charles G. Editor of Catholic (The) encyclopedia. Special ed. 16v. 26cm. N. Y, 1913-14. HERBERT, Elias, & FELLER, Adolf. Stau- ungstypen bei Kreislaufstorungen mit besonderer Berucksichtigung der exudativen Perikarditis; eine anatomische experimentelle und klinische Untersuchung. 2 p. 1. 232p. 8? Wien, J. Springer, 1926. HERBERT, Jean Jules, 1905- *Etude sur le cancer du corps thyroide. 109p. 7 pl. 8? Par., Jouve & cie, 1935. HERBERT, J[ohn] Frederick, 1860-192-[?] Anatomy and physiology of the eye, with hints for the preservation of the eyesight. 2. ed. 68p. 12? Phila., 1901. HERBERT, L[eon] M[oses] 1885- See Golden. L, Herbert. L. M, & Goldstein, A. Rephuah system of medicine, v.l. 218p. 8! N. Y, 1927. HERBERT, Ludwig, 1905- *Erfolge der Behandlung von Hydrops, Xephropathie und Praeeklampsie gravidarum durch diatetische Massnahmen [Giessen] 20p. 8? Aachen [n. pub.] 1934. HERBERT 593 HERBRAND HERBERT, Madeleine, 1905- *Explora- tion radiologique des voix biliaires par injection des substances opaques; indications, technique, resultats. 67p. 8? Par., M. Lac, 1932. HERBERT, S. Mervyn. Britain's health. xviii, 219p. 18em. Harmondsworth, Eng., Penguin Books ltd [1939] HERBERT, W. E. See Parfltt. J. B, & Herbert, W. E. Operative dental surgery. 4. ed. 477p. 22^cm. Lond, 1939. HERBERT, Werner, 1913- Verglei- chende Untersuchungen iiber den Wert von Brillantgrun-Phenolrot- und Malaehitgrunagar fiir den Fleischvergifternachweis bei primarer Aussaat. 39p. 21}^cm. Giessen, O. Kindt, 1937. HERBERT-CAESARI, Edgar F. The science and sensations of vocal tone; a school of natural vocal mechanics, xxiv, 199p. port, diagrs. 8? Lond., J. M. Dent & sons [1936] HERBERTZ, Hilde. *PufferstofTe im Blut. [Munchen] 28p. 21cm. Kallmiinz, M. Lassle- ben, 1937. HERBERTZ, R. Der Alkoholgenuss als Wertproblem. 78p. 8? Basel, B. Schwabe & co. [1937] HERBET, pseud. Le bon medecin; hygiene, medecine, soins d'urgence. 448p. 195 illust. 12? Par., Larousse [1931] HERBICIDE. See also Weed. Aslander, A. Sulphuric acid as a weed spray. J. Agr. Res, 1927, 34: 1065-91.—Bates, G. H. Vanadium pentoxide as a catalyst for sodium chlorate in weed destruction. Nature, Lond, 1941, 148: 753.—Catchings, T. F, Padget, L. J, & Dawsey, L. H. Herbicide. U. S. Patent Off, 1940, No. 2,218,787.—Jayne, D. W, jr. Material for destroying vegetation. Ibid, 1942, No. 2,2o9,396 — Osborne, J. L. Composition of matter. Ibid, No. 2,209,397.—Ralston, A. W, & Vander Wal, R. J. Weed killing composition. Ibid, 1940, No. 2,209,905 — Tanner, W. L. Weed destroying preparation. Ibid, No. 2,200,470. HERBIG, Lothar, 1911- *Ein Beitrag zur Frage der Nabelversorgung [Berlin] 45p. 8? Jena, G. Neuenhahn, 1937. HERBIVORA. McCay, C. M, Madsen, L. I., & Maynard, L. A. Further studies of synthetic diets for Herbivora. J. Biol. Chem, 1933, 100: p. lxviii. HERBOLARIUM. 172 1. 4? Venezia, Simon Bevilaqua, Dec. 14, 1499. HERBOLARIUM. 154 1. 4? Venezia, Alessandro de Dendoni, 1507-22. HERBOLARIUM. 167 1. sm. 4? Venezia, Johannes & Bernardinus Rubeus, Mar. 15, 1508. HERBOLARIUM. 171 1. 4? Venezia, Johannes & Bernardinus Rubeus, 1509. HERBOLD, Karl, 1911- *Drei Falle von Nachblutungen nach Contusio bulbi [Heidel- berg] 39p. 22>^cm. Walldorf, F. Lamade, 1936. HERBORN, Carl, 1899- *Statistische Untersuchungen am Myommaterial der Miin- chener Universitats-Frauenklinik. 26p. 8? Munch., L. Mossl, 1928. HERBRAND, Elsbeth, 1901- *Johann Casper Kiichler, Arzt und Mitglied der Leipziger Fakultat [Leipzig] 22p. 8? Osehatz, C. Morgner, 1928. HERBRAND, Hans, 1909- *Einfluss der Arbeit auf Schwangerschaft, Geburt und Neuge- borenes [Berlin] 41p. 23cm. Werdau, J. Booch, 1936. 227475—VOL. 7, 4th series----38 HERBRAND, Jakob, 1907- ♦Nachunter- suchungen uber operierte und nichtoperierte Meniskusverletzungen an der Bonner chirur- gischen Universitats-Klinik von 1908 zu 1930 80p. 8? Bonn, P. Kubens, 1931. HERBRICH, Kurt [Otto Paul] 1909- *Beitrag zur Epidemiologie und Klinik der Tuberkulosis verrucosa cutis. 24p. 8° Berl Neuland, 1935. HERBST, Adolf, 1904- *Klinische Be- obachtungen uber die lymphoidzellige Angina; an Hand von 57 Krankheitsf alien [Berlinl 19p 8? Bresl., K. Vater, 1931. HERBST, Amelie Marie, 1906- *Ueber konservative Empyembehandlung. 23p. 8? Wiirzb., Gebr. Memminger, 1931. HERBST, Emil, 1872- Atlas und Grund- riss fiir die Mechanik der Kiefer-Orthopadie. vii, 223p. 12? Munch., J. F. Lehmann, 1923. Forms Bd 40, Lehmann's Med. Handatlanten. ----& APFFELSTAEDT, Max. Atlas und Grundriss der Missbildungen der Kiefer und Zahne. viii, 321p. 8? Miinch., J. F. Lehmann, 1928. ---- The same. Malformations of the jaws and teeth, xii, 320p. 8? Lond., Oxford Univ. Press, 1930. HERBST, Erich, 1910- *Ueber die Porphyrien, allgemeine Betrachtungen und eine Zusammenstellung der bislang bekanntgewor- denen Krankheitsf alle. 43p. 23cm. Berl., R. Pfau, 1937. HERBST, Georg, 1911- *Die Schwel- lungen der Halslymphknoten der Kinder bei Tuberkulose und Scharlach und ihre inneren und ausseren Ursachen. 33p. 8? Erlangen, K. Dores, 1936. HERBST, Hans, 1901- *Bericht iiber die zweite Halfte des XXVI. Tausend der Geburten an der Universitats-Frauenklinik zu Wurzburg. 71p. 8° Wiirzb., G. Grasser, 1928. HERBST, Siegfried, 1912- *Die bio- logische Schwangerschaftsreaktion am Kaninchen mit eigenen Versuchen. 16p. 21em. Jena, G. Neuenhahn, 1938. HERBST, Werner, 1910- *Beitrag zur Klinik und Therapie der Pseudarthrose. 21p. 20^cm. Konigsb. i. Pr., J. Raabe, 1937. HERBST, William, 1833-1907. [Biography] In Some Am. M. Botanists (H. A. Kelly) N. Y, 1929, 190. HERCBERG, Chaim. *Vegetative Symptome bei Parkinson'schen Symptomenkomplexen. 29p. 23cm. Basel, J. Heuberger, 1937. HERCELLES, Oswaldo, -1938. F, G. Biographia. Gac. peru. cir. med, 1938-39, 1: No. 10 7 portr.—Homenaje (El) al Profesor Oswaldo Hercelles. Rev. mid. peru, 1940, 12: 309.—Lastres. J. B. [Obituary] Ibid, 1938, 10: 574-6, portr. HERCHENRODER, M. The atmospheric pressure at Mauritius; being a survey and dis- cussion of 56 years' observations made at the Royal Alfred Observatory. 21p. 12 tab. 7 ch. 8? Port Louis, Gov. Print., 1937. Forms Pub. No. 18. Roy. Alfred Observ. HERCIK, Ferdinand, 1905- Oberflachen- spannung in der Biologie und Medizin. xii, 224p. illust. tab. diagrs. 8? Dresd., T. Steinkopff, 1934. HERCOG, Erno. *Ueber den Einfluss des Jodkaliums, einiger Hormone, der Glukose, auf den refraktometrischen Index des Blutserums und eine Gesamtserummengebestimmung mit Gummiarabicum [Basel] 32p. 8? Petrovgr., Schneller & Briider Goschl, 1935. 94 HEREDITY HERCUS HERCUS, C. E. Goitre in the light of recent research; C'awthron lecture, Sept. 5, 1929, the Cawthron Institute, Nelson, New Zealand. 22p. 10 pl. 8? Nelson, R. W. Stiles & co., 1930. ---- Women and national survival; Wilding memorial lecture 1940. 24p. incl. diagr. 21cm. [Dunedin, N. Z., 1942] In Proc. Univ. Otago M. School, No. 19, 1942. HERCZEG, Arpad [The life and works of John Manardus] 69p. portr. 10 pl. facs. 8? Budap., Magyar Tudomanyos Akad., 1929. HERCZOG, Andor, 1904- *Stumpfe Bauehverletzungen aus der Leipziger chirurgi- schen Klinik in der Zeit von 1917-27. 48p. 8? Lpz., E/M. Loffier, 1928. HERD, Henry. The diagnosis of mental deficiency, xi, 272p. 6 pl. 8? Lond., Hoddei & Stoughton, 1930. HERDEG, Howard B. Practical health talks. 28 1. 4? Buffalo, N. Y., H. B. Herdeg, 1935. Mimeographed. HERDLS, Wilhelm [Theodor] 1903- *Ist die Nichtbehandlung der Lues von Einfluss auf den sptiteren Ausbruch der Paralyse? 31p. 8? Bonn, P. Kubens, 1932. HERDING, Liselotte, 1912- *Bericht iiber die Poliomyelitis-Epidemie 1934 der Univer- sitats-Kinderklinik zu Rostock unter besonderer Beriicksichtigung der Therapie mit Rekonvales- zentenserum [Rostock] 37p. 8? Gutersloh, Thiele, 1935. HEKDLE, Eugen, 1905- *Zur Morpho- genie des Unterkiefers und des Tuberculum articulare beim Menschen [Heidelberg] 56p. ch. 8? Bernburg, A. Volkel, 1928. HERDMAN, William James, 1848-1906 Guide to the dissection of the human body, ii, 30p. 8? Ann Arb., Mich., G. Osius & co., 1883. ---- DUFF, A. Wilmer [et al.] Internationa! text-book of medical electro-physics and gal- vanism; for the use of medical students and practitioners, xxxii, v. p. 8? Phila., F. A. Davis, 1895. HERE begynneth the proprytees and medy- cynes for hors. [24]p. 2 illust. 22^cm. [Lond., ca. 1525] Incomplete. Photostat facs. (H. E. Huntington Library) HEREDIA y Velasco, Pablo Beltran de. Arteriografia cerebral. 71p. pl. 8? Salamanca Hernandez. 1932. HERD instinct. See Gregariousness; Group, Psychology. HEREDITAS; genetiskt arkiv. Lund, v.l, 1920- HEREDITY. See also Allelomorphism; Breeding; Chromo- some; Consanguinity; Constitution; Eugenics; Genetics; Mendelism; Mutation, &c. Contributions to human heredity in honour of Msria Anna Van Herwerden. 156p. 251/4cm. Hogue, 1936. Grerne, C. A. Build well; the basis of in- dividual, home, and national elevation; plain truths relating to the obligations of marriage and parentage. 227p. 8? Bost. [1885] Handbuch der Erbbiologie des Menschen. 2v. 1324p. paged consec. 25cm. Berl., 1939. [Germany] 1'und der Deutschen. Abt. BEVbLKERiNGsroLiTiK. Schriftenreihe C (Wiss. Reihe) H. 1: > cuere Fragen der Erbbiologie. 55p. 23cm. Teplitz-Schonau, 1938. Scheinfeld, A. You and heredity. 434p 22cm. N. Y., 1939. Schmucker, S. C. Heredity and parenthood 322p. 8? N. Y., 1929. Snyder, L. H. The principles of heredity 2. ed. 152p. 23cm. Bost. [1940] Castro, A. Notas sobre ln herencia. Ropert. med. cir Bogotd. 1930, 21: 374-8:!.— Davison. M. II. A. Heredity Univ. Durham Coll. M. Gaz, 1933, .1.1: S9-!>7— Frets, <;. p. [Some examples of heredity in man] Neil, mschr. geneesk 1930-31, 17: 725-35.—Gates, U. It. Aspects of physical and mental inheritance. Nature, Lond, 1920, 1LS: 603-5.— Korcisy, K. [Essentials of heredity] Orvosk6pzes, 1934. 24: 37-52.—Mutcl. Experience sur l'her6dit£ d'un cnraciri,. Rev. med. Nancy, 1936, 64: 317-20.—Nicholson. <;. \\ Heredity. Guy's Hosp. Rep, Lond, 1928, 78: 35-58.— Rabaude, E. A propos d'heredite. Bull, biol. Par, 1937 71- 22-30.—Scorgie, N. J. Telegony. Vet. Ucc, Loud, 1942, 54: 68.—Steiner, B. Vererbung. \Vien. med. Wschr, 1935, 85: 933-5.— W hat you inherit from your parents. J. Am. Electron Res. Ass, 1940, 18: 84. ---- Acquired characters. Barry, C. *Essai critique sur I'hdriditd dea caracteres rrorbides acquis par I'homme. 76p. 8? Par., 1935. Ciaudo, J. A. E. *Lc probleme de l'lxSr&litd des caracteres acquis. 48p. 8? Par., 1936. Boffmann, L. *Les mutilations ne sont paa hereditaires. 47p. 8? Par., 1927. Labarre, R. *Contribution a l'etude de Phdrddite" des mutilations. 76p. 8? Par., 1931. Zimmerman, W. Vererbung erworbener Eigen- schaften und Auslese. 347p. 25cm. Jena, 1938. Agar, W. K. A review of some experiments currently quoted as evidence of the inheritance of acquired characters. Austral. J. Exp. Biol, 1932, 9: 179-90. ------ Drummond. F. H, & Tiegs, O. W. A first report on a test of M cDougall's Lamarck- inn experiment on the training of rats. J. Exp. Biol, Lond., 1935, 12: 191-211—Canella, M. F. Heteditariedad de los carilcteres adquiridos; cuestionario e hip6lesis de trabajo. In his Orient biol. mod, B. Air, 940, 101 -201.—Cast ddi, L. L'eredita dei rarnltcri acquisili e l'csperimento. Studium, Nap, 1928, 18: 331-6- Cheeley, P, & Dunn, L. C. The inheritance of tnillcssncss (anury) in Ihe house mouse. Genet- ics, 1936, 21: 525-36- Davenport, C. B. An alleged case of inheritance of acquired characters. Am. Nairn.. lf'33, C7: 549-58.— Devaux, I.'. L'enigrre de rherfdite des caracteres acouis. Bev. gin. sc. ]>ur./l933, 44: 097-708- Dioni'i, A. Din ostrazione dellfiedita dei caiatteii acquisiti. Piv. biol, 1940, 29: 140-53- Drew. G. C. McDoupall's experiments on the inheritance of acquired habits. Nntuie, lond., 1939, 143: 188-91.— Dufton, A. F. The inheiitance of acquiied cliaiactors, Eugen. Rev, lond, 1934, 25: 245-9. Edmonds, H. W , & Kccler, C. E. Natural ear-ring holes; iidieiiled sinuses of the ear lobe. J. Ilcrcd, 1940, 31: 507-10.- ) cdciley, H. Weshalb lehnt die Cenetik die Annahme einer Yeieibung erworbener Eigenschaften ab? Zschr. indukt. Abstamm, 1930, 51: 20-43 [Discussion] 43-50.—Ferriere. A. L'ne theorie dynamique de ['hirtdili ct le proMme de la transmission des caractcre? acquis. Rev. psychol, Brux, 1912, 5: 117-51.—Fefrher, R. Ennorbene Meikmale und Nachkommenschaft. Arch, sozial. Hyg, 1929, n. F„ 4: 401-6.------Vereibung erworbener Eigenschaften. ■ Lmschau, 1929, 33: 121-3.—Harrison, .1. W. H. Experiments on the egg-laying instincts of the sawfly, Pontania salicis Christ, and their bearing on the inheritance of acquired characters; with some remarks on a new principle in evolution. Proc. IL Soc, Lond, ser. B, 1927. 101: 115-26.— Hink. A. Zum Begriff der erworbenen Eigenschaften und deren Vererbung. Deut. tierarztl. Wschr, 1939, 47: 479.—King, H. D. Studies on the inheritance of structural anomalies in the rat. Am. J. Anat, 1931, 48: 231-00.—Kosswig. V. Die Evolution von Anpassungs-Merkn'alen bei Hohlentieren in genetischer Betrachtung. Zool. Anz, 1935 112: 14X-55.— Lesage, P. Sur l'heredite de la precocit6 acquise dans le Lcpidium sativum. C. rend. Acad, sc, 1931, 199: 971-3.— Morgan, T. H. The apparent inheritance of an acquired character and its explanation. Am. Natur, 1930, 64: 97- H-t—Parhon, C. I, & Marza, V. Les globes oculaires chez les petits nes de parents ayant subi l'enucleation des yeux. C. rend. Soc. biol, 1029. 100: 43.—Plate, L. Hypothese einer vanablen Erbkraft bei polyallelen Cenen und bei Radikalen, ein Weg zur Erklarung der Vererbung erworbener Eigen- schaften. Acta biotheor, Leiden, 1930, 2: 93-125— llichet. C. Stability hdrdditaire des caracteres acquis. C. rend. Acad. sc, 1933, 197: 433.—Sakharov, G. P. [Hereditv of acquired characters] Med. biol. J, Leningr, 1929. 5: 5-17.—Schilling, C, & Schreck, H. Bleiben erworbene biologische Eigenschaften pathogener Protozoen bei der Passage durch die nattirlichcn Uebertrager erhalten? Arch. Schiffs Tropenhyg, 1032, 36: 105-7.—Schmidt, G. A. [Lateral change of inductive properties in the organization center of tailless amphibian*] Biol. J, Moskva, 1936, 5: 145-74, 12 pl.—Schreiber, G. A propos de HEREDITY 595 HEREDITY la communication de M. Victor Cathala: Hiridxti d'une mutilation acquise. Bull. Soc. pddiat. Paris, 1931, 29: 90-4.— «j«»rharoff. G. P. Beitrag zur Frage der Vererbung erworbener Eigenschaften. Zschr. ges. exp. Med, 1929, 68: 411-24. ____ Vorlaufige Ergebnisse einer Beobachtung iiber die Vererbung erworbener Eigenschaften. Zschr. indukt. Abstamm, 1930 55' 145-54.—Turpin, R. L'avenir des caracteres acquis. progr. med. Par, 1932, 682-9.—Weber, A. L'heredit6 des caracteres acquis et l'anatomie humaine. Rev. mid. est, 1920, 54: 6-9.—Zeleny, C. Non-inheritance of the temperature effect on bar eye in Drosophila melanogaster. Am. Natur, 1928 62- 88-90.—-Zimmermann, W. Die Vererbung erwor- bener Eigenschaften. Med. KUn, Berl, 1935, 31: 197. .--- animal. Beadle, G. W, & Tatum, E. L. Genetic control of develop- mental reactions. Biol. Sympos, Lane, 1941, 4: 173-82.— Caridroit, F, & Regnier, V. [Etude physiologique de quelque cas d'h6rfdit6 dans la volaillc] In Probl. biol. med. (Leonto- vich, A. V.) Moskva, 1935, 666-73.—D'Ancona, U. Influenze ambientali e manifestazioni ereditarie nei mondo animale. Riv. biol, 1937, 23: 298-315.—Darbishire, A. D. Recent advances in animal breeding and their bearing on our knowledge of heredity. Rep. Internat. Conf. Genet. (1906) 1907, 3. Conf, 130-7.—Gordon, M. Dominant recessive responses of the Sd factor in natural and domesticated fish populations. Genetics, 1942, 27: 144.—Gottschewski, G, & Buck, J. B. Weitere Tran'splantationsexperimente an Drosophila melanogaster und D. pseudoobscura: das Gen clot. Zschr. indukt. Abstamm, 1937-38 74: 460-4.—Harvey, E. B. Maternal inheritance in echinoderm hybrids. Biol. Bull, 1941. 81: 288.—Walton, A, & Hammond. J. The maternal effects on growth and conforma- tion in Shire-horse-Shetland-pony crosses. Proc. R. Soc, Lond, 1938, 125: ser. B, 311-35, 2 pl. ---■ Effect of environment. See Environment. ---■ familial. Strohmater, W. Die Vererbung des Habs- burger Familientypus. p.219-66. 25^cm. Halle, 1937. Birk, W. Ueber familiiare Erkrankungen. Mschr. Kinderh, 1934 62: 173-9.— Fischer, M. Aehnlichkeit und Ahnenge- meinschaft. Zschr. Morph. Anthrop, 1934, 34: 94-104, pl, ch.—Stapleford. A. D. Earlv history of the Judkins family. Lancet Clinic, 1912, 107: 65.—Thorndike, E. L. Familial resemblances in composites of desirable traits. J. Hered.. 1939, 30: 391. --- Folk-lore, and history. Labus, J. *Geschichtlicher Beitrag zu dem Problem der Vererbung von Krankheiten. 20p. 8? Freib. i. B., 1929. Beck, W. Erbpathologische Hinweise in Morgagnis Haupt- werk, De sedibus et causis morborum. Virchows Arch, 1939- 40, 305: 521-30.—Dunlap, K. Antidotes for superstitions concerning human heredity. Sc. Month, 1940. 51: 221-5.— McCartney. E. S. Acquired and transmitted characters in Greek lore of hercditv. Pap>ers Michigan Acad. Sc. (1926) 1927, 7: 21-40—Rodiet, A, & Queron. Historique de la notion de I'heredite mentale avant le XX« sidcle et k notre epoque. Progr. med. Par, 1935, 1551-5. --- Mechanism. Correns, C. Nicht mendelnde Vererbung. 159p. 261/2cm. Berl., 1937. Guggisberg, H. Vererbung und Uebertra- gung. 21p. 8? Bern, 1920. Jennings, H. S. The laws of heredity and our present knowledge of human genetics on the material side, p.3-73. 22cm. Wash., 1911. Belgovsky, M. L, Kirpichnikov, V. S, & Prokofleva. Belgovskaia, A. A. [Differentiation of the cell and chromosome theory of heredity] BuU. Acad. sc. URSS, 1940, ser. biol, 026- 87.—Castle, W. E. Experimental studies of heredity in small mammals. Yearb. Carnegie Inst. Washington, 1941, No. 40, 267-9— Del Roncal, F. P. Fundamentos biologicos de la herencia. Eugenesia, Mex, 1941, 2: No. 25, 4-13.—Dob- zhansky, T. Are racial and specific characters non-mendelian? J. Mammal, 1934, 15: 1-3.—Gunther. H. Ueber periodische Vorg-inge bei der menschlichen Vererbung. Biol. Zbl, 1932, 52: 523.—Hrdlicka, A. Some reflections regarding human heredity. Proc. Am. Philos. Soc, 1935, 75: 295-312. Also repr.—Hurst, C. C. The mechanism of heredity and evolution. Eugen. Rev, Lond, 1927-28, 19: 19-31. Huskins, C. L, & Newcombe, H. B. Genetic and cytological interference. Nature, Lond, 1939, 143: 808.—Jennings, H. S, & Lynch, R. S. Age, mortnliiv, and individual diversities in the rotifer Proales Bordida Gosse; effect of age of the parent on characteristics of the offspring. J. Exp. Zool, 1928, 50: 345-407. —Kappert, H. 1st das Alter der zu Kreuzungen verwandten Individuen auf die Auspragung der elterlichen Merkmale bei den Nachkommen von Einfluss? Biol. Zbl, 1922, 42: 223-31.—Koehler. O. Ueber den Einfluss des Keimzellalters auf die Vererbun^srich- tung Ibid, 1923, 43: 131-48.—Le Rasle, H. Specificity et heredite sanguines. J. med. fr, 1926, 15: 362-6.—L'Heritier, P, & Teissier, G. TJn mecanisme hereditaire aberrant chez la! drosophile. C. rend. Acad, sc, 1938, 206: 1193-5.—Mali- novsky, A. A. [Regulation of heredity from the view-point of Darwin's theory of selection] Usp. sovrem. biol, 1941, 14: 171-6.—Mayo, M. La acci6n del medio y la herencia. Med d. hoy, Habana, 1939, 4: 311-7.—Morgan, T. H. An exami- nation of the so-called process of contamination of genes. Anat Rec, 1916-17, 11: 503. ------• The mechanism and laws of heredity. In Handb. Gen. Exp. Psychol. (Murchison, C.) Worcester, 1934, 109-54. ------ Schultz, J, & Curry. V. Investigations on the constitution of the germinal material in relation to heredity. Yearb. Carnegie Inst. Washington (1939-40) 1940, 39: 251; 1941, 40: 282.—Schmilfuss, H, & Werner, H. Chemismus der Entstehung von Eigenschaften Zschr. indukt. Abstamm, 1926, 41: 285-358, 10 tab.—Stockard, C. R. The presence of a factorial basis for characters lost in evolution; the atavistic reappearance of digits in mammals. Am. J. Anat, 1930, 45: 345-75, pl.—Thone, F. Modes of heredity in human beings described. Chem. Leaflet, 1941-42, 15: No. 7, 65.—Tjebbes, D. S, K. Polvmerism. Bibliogr. genet, Gravenh, 1931, 8: 227-94— Tschermak, A. Ueber neue Anregungen fur die Vererbungslehre durch die Theorie der hybridogenen Genasthenie und der Chromosomenaddition. Med. Klin, Berl, 1930. 26: 1851-3.—Wright, S. Effects of age of parents on characteristics of the guinea pig. Am. Natur 1926, 60: 552-9.—Yule. G. U. On the theory of inheritance of quantitative compound characters on the basis of Mendel's laws; a preliminary note. Rep. Internat. Conf. Genet. (1906) 1907, 3. Conf, 140-2. ---- Medical aspect. Davenport, C. B., Keeler, C. E. [et al.] Medical genetics and eugenics. 141p. 23^cm. Phila. [1940] Barker, L. F. Heredity in the clinic. Am. J. M. Sc, 1927, 173: 597-605.—Bauer, K. H. Erbkrankheiten und Versichj- rung vom Standpunkt der Chirurgie. Arch, orthop. UnfaUchir, 1936-37, 37: 304-11.—Golla, F. Chirurgie und Erbpathologie. In Neuere Fragen Erbbiol. (Germany. Bund der Deut.) Teplitz, H. 1, 1938, 33-44.—Heredity (A) clinic [University of Michigan] Human Fertility, 1941, 6: 159.—Hodson, C. The Bureau of Human Heredity. Congr. internat. popul. (1937) 1938, 1. Congr, 8: 123.—International Human Heredity Committee. Ber. Versamml. Internat. Fed. eugen. Org, 1936, 12. Conf, 100-12.—Macklin, M. T. Heredity and the physician. Sc. Month, 1941, 52: 56-67.—Meggendorfer, F. Die erbbiolo- grschen Ergebnisse in der iibrigen Medizin. In Erblehre & Rassenhyg. (R. Riidin) Munch, 1934, 230-56.—Rosenfeld, M. Erbliche Belastung; Vorgeschichte und Personlichkeitstvpus des Kranken. Deut. med. Wschr, 1928, 54: 230-3.—Weitz. Innere Erbkrankheiten und Versicherung. Arch, orthop. UnfaUchir, 1936-37, 37: 293-304. ---- Mental traits. See also names of general and specific mental faculties. Berger, C. A. Human psychological in- heritance. p.77-92. 22cm. Wash., 1941. Gun, W. T. J. Studies in hereditary ability. 288p. 8? Lond., 1928. Kroh, 0. Erbpsychologie der Berufsneigung und der Berufseignung sowie der Sonderbega- bungen. p.592-668. 25cm. Berl., 1939. Lawrence, E. M. An investigation into the relation between intelligence and inheritance. 80p. 25>'2cm. Cambr., 1931. Outhit, M. C. A study of the resemblance of parents and children in general intelligence [Columbia Univ.] 60p. 8? N. Y., 1933. Anderson, H. H. An examination of the concepts of domina- tion and integration in relation to dominance and ascendance. Psychol Rev, 1940, 47: 21-37.—Begabung und Herkunft. Deut. Aerzte Ztg* 1933, 8: No. 391.—Behr-Pinnow, C. von. Vererbung geistiger Anlagen in der Familie Bernoulli. Deut. med. Wschr, 1934, 60: 554. Also Naturwissenschaften, 1934, 22: 717-21. ------ Vererbung und Begabung. Umschau, 1934, 38: 705-7.—Bemmelen, J. F. van. Heredity of mental faculties. Proc. Akad. wet. Amsterdam, 1927, 30: pt 2, Sect. Sc, 769-95. Also Versl. Akad. wet. Amsterdam, 1927, 36: pt 2 Afd. Naturk, 787-816.—Bogen, H. Vererben sich die Berufsanlagen? Umschau, 1928, 32: 309-11.— Bonnevie, K. Papillarmuster und psychische Eigenschaften. Hereditas, Lund, 1927, 9: 180-92.—Carter, H. D. Family resemblances in verbal and numerical abilities. Genet. Psychol. Monogr., 1932 12: 1-104.—Coutts, W. E. Heranca psychica intra- HEREDITY 596 HEREDITY utcrina. Rev. med. cir. Brasil, 1929, 37: 507-602.—Fischer, E. Rasse und Vererbung geistiger Eigenschaften. Zschr. Morph. Anthrop.. 1939, 38: 1-9.—Fischer. G. H. Seclenkunde und Erbgedai i. Zschr. piidag. Psychol, 1941, 42: 35-44 — Gerlach. I. Eugenik und die krankhaften geistigen Erban- lagen. /.-hr. Gesundhverwalt,. 1032. 3: 217-20.—Gott- schaldt, K. Leber die Vererbung von Intelligenz und( 'haraktcr. Fortsch. Erbpath, 1937. 1: 1-21. Haeckcr. V, & Ziehen. T. Beitrag zur Lehre von der Vererbung ui'.d Analyse der zeich- nerischen und mathematischen Begabung. insbesondere mit Bczug auf die Korrelation zur musikalixchen Begabung. Zschr. Psychol. l'h> -i.pmrnt in IVi piatensis L. Ibid, 1940, 31: 457-0L- Wcllcnsick. S. J, it Kcyscr. J. S. Pisum-crosses; inherited abortion and its linkage-relations. Genetica, Gravenh, 1928-29, 11: 329-34. ---- precessive. Hcnyer, G, & Logre, B. J. L'hfirdditfi precessive. Bull med. Par, 1929, 13: 241. Also Prat, me 1. fr, 1910. 11: 411- 6.— Pieraccini, G. L'anticipazione nello malattie ercdo- farailiari. Gazz. osp, 1929, 50: 1495-8. ---- recessive. See also Gen, recessive. Bernstein. F. Korrekturen bei erblichkeitsmathematischer Untersuchung von Krankheiten mit rezes.srvem Erb"ang Arch. Rassenb.. 1932-33, 27: 25-31.—Bruvnoirhe, It. L'hcre- dit6 des affections du type rficcssif. Rev. med, Louvain, l'.)34 353-60. — Spilln an, W. J. A method of calculating the per- centage of recessive s from incomplete data. Am. Natur, 1915 49: 383.-Weil/, W. Leber die Haufigkeit des Vorkommena des gleichen Leidens bei den Verwandten cine? an einem cinfach rezessiven Leiden Erkrankten. Arch. Rassenb, 1932-33, 27: 12-24. ---- Research, and examination. Bleuler, M. Erbanalytische Forschung. Erbarzt, 1941, 9: 12-6.—Burks, B. S. Research projects in the field of human heredity. Yearb. Carnegie Inst. Washington (1939-40) 1940, 39: 240-2; 1041, 40: 200.—Caullery, M. A propos des Com- mentaires sur l'h6re-dite. Bull, biol. Par, 1937, 71: 1-9.— Diagnosis of hereditary diseases. Eugen. News, 1938, 23: 46.—Fisher, R. A, & Gray, H. Inheritance in man: Boas's data studied by the method of analysis of variance. Ann. Eugen, Cambr,. 1937, 8: 74-93.—Geller, W. Was kann die physiologische Chemie zur Diagnostik der Erbkrankheiten bcitragen? Psychiat. neur. Wschr, 1936, 38: 307-12.— Gutlmacher, A. F. Twins as a measure of heredity. In his Human Sex Life, N. Y, 1940, 258-70.—MUtmann, O. Zum Nachweis des Erbgangs bei Merkmalen mit iibcrgreifenden Erscheinungsformen. Zschr. menschl. Vererb, 1937-38, 21: 476-95.—Rabaud, E. Commentaires sur l'heredite. Bull. biol., Par, 1936, 70: 409-55.—Snyder, L. H. The study of human heredity. Sc. Month, 1940, 51: 530-41.—Sontag, L. W. Research at the Fels institute. Trained Nurse, 1938, 100: 648-51. ---- sex-linked, and sex-influenced. See also Gen, sex-linked. Foyn, B. Geschlechtsgebundene und ge- schlechtskontrollierte Vererbung. 122p. 8? Berl., 1932. Csik, L, & Mather, K. The sex incidence of certain heredi- tary traits in man. Ann. Eugen, Cambr, 1937-38, 8: 126— 45.—Fleischer. Die Vererbung geschlechtsgebundener Krank- heiten. Ber. Deut. ophth. Ges. (1920) 1921, 42: 4-14.— Gunther, H. Ueber erbliche Sexualdisposition zu Krankheiten. Endokrinologie, 1935, 16: 327-38.—Hager, R. P. Sex-linkage of stubby in Habrobracon. Biol. Bull, 1941, 81: 298 — Lamoreux, W. F. The autosexing Ancobar. J. Hered, 1941, 32: 221-6. ---- Social aspect. Btjrlingame, L. L. Heredity and social problems. 369p. 23y2cm. N. Y., 1940. Klein, H. V. Krankheit, Vererbung und Ehe; eine medizinisch-sozialwissenschaftliche Stu- die mit besonderer Berucksichtigung des Ge- schlechtslebens. 243p. 8? Lpz., 1921. Lidbetter, E. J. Heredity and the social problem group. 160p. 8? Lond., 1933. ---- Survey. Hove, M. van. *Untersuchungen iiber Haufigkeit von Erbkrankheiten im Kreise Leer unter besonderer Berucksichtigung des Gesetzea zur Verhiitung erbkranken Nachwuchses und der Stammbaumforschung [Munster] 42p. 21cm. Bottrop, 1936. Josten, K. *Erbhygienische Untersuchungen an den Kindern der Hilfsschulen in Neuss und Krefeld-Uerdingen [Munster] 15p. 21cm. Neuss, 1937. HEREDITY 599 HERFORTH Szymanski, A. *Erbhygienische Untersuchun- gen an Hilfsschulkindern in der Stadt Gladbcck in Westfalen. 24p. 21cm. Munster i.Westf., 1937. . J ,_ . . , Bonnier. G. Inherited s°x-mosaic in man and the statistrcal treatment of such data (an answer to Professor S. G. Levit) Hereditas, Lund, 1938, 24: 405-70.—Keiter, F. Der Anteil an Erbkranken unter den Patienten der Hamburger Haut- und Augcnklinik. Med. Welt, 1936, 10: 135-7.—Liermann, G. Der Intelligenzprufungsbogen nach Anlage 5a der ersten Verordnung zur Durchfuhrvmg des Gesetzes zur Verhiitung erbkranken Nachwuchses in seiner Anwendung bei Jugend- lichen in der Stadt Konigsberg i. Pr. und dem Samland im Alter von 14-18 Jahren. Oeff. Gesundhdienst, 1939-40, 5: A, 244-54.— Schultze-Naumburg, A. Statistische Untersuchun- gen an den Hilfsschiilern Pommerns. Arch. Rassenb, 1935. 29: 153 86. HEREDOSYPHILIS. See Syphilis, congenital. HEREFORD, Engl. Dispensary and the Provident Branch [Dispensary established 1835; Branch established 1881] Rules with report of the transactions. Hereford, 53.,1887 88; 61.-69., 1895/96 1903/4; 72.-78., 1906/7-1912/13. HEREFORD COUNTY, and City Lunatic Asylum. Annual report. Hereford, 1.-10., 1872- 81; 11.-14., 1882-85; 16.-31., 1887-1903; 33., 1905; 40., 1912. HEREFORDSHIRE General Hospital [for- merly Hereford General Infirmary; established 1770] Annual report. Hereford, 101.-113., 1876- 88; 115.-123., 1800-98; 1902; 1914-15. HERELLE, Felix d' See D'Herelle, Felix. HERESBACH, Konrad, 1508-76. Rei rusticae lib. IV [ed. Johannes Heresbach] [14] 889p. [29] 8? Speyer, Smesmann, 1594. HERESI H., Jose. *Porvenir del diente apicectomizado [Chile] 32p. 26>^cm. Santiago, El Imparcial, 1939. HERFELD, Alfred, 1912- *Experimen- telle Untersuchungen iiber Kuhleffekt und Feuchtigkeitsabgabe von Kiihlsalben [Munchen] 43p. pl. 21cm. Gorlitz, Hoffmann & Reiber, 1938. HERFERT, Oskar, 1908- *Kritische Be- trachtung der bekanntesten Methoden des Symmetrievergleichs in der orthodontischen Diagnostik. 24p. 8? Bresl., A. Schreiber, 1931. HERFF, Dorothee von. Die klinische Be- deutung der Arzneimittel als Antigene; soge- nannte Arzneimittelidiosynkrasien. 80p. illust. tab. 8? Lpz., G. Thieme. 1937. HERFF, Ferdinand, 1820-1912. Bliem, M. J. Biography. Med. Rev. of Rev, N. Y., 1933, 39: 560-73. HERFF, Otto von, 1856- , WALTHARD, M., & WILDBOLZ, H. Das Kindbettfieber. p.255-1025. 8? Wiesbaden, 1906. In Handb. Geburtshulfe (F. v. Winckel) Weisbaden, 1906, Bd 3, T. 2. HERFORT, Alfred [Gustav Willi] 1896- *Zwei Falle von Spaltureter, ein Beitrag zur Kenntnis der Doppelureteren. p.1170-81. 8? Berl., E. Ebering, 1926. Also Zbl. Gyn, 1927, 51: HERFORT, Georg [Hermann] 1906- *Ueber Volksmedizin und Aberglaube in der Heilkunde des Riesengebirges [Breslau] 23p. 8? Arnsdorf [n. pub.] 1937-38. HERFORT, Karel, 1871-1940. Studnicka, F. K. [Obituary] Cas. lek. 6esk,1940, 79: 315, HERFORT, Karl Heinz [Wilhelm] 1913- *Hufeland als Lehrer und klinischer Direktor [Berlin] 31p. 8? Lengerich, Lengerich. Han- delsdr.. 1938. HERFORTH, Hans, 1911- *Die todliche Schlagermensur in strafrechtlicher Beziehung 31p. 8? Bresl., K. Vater, 1936. HERFORTH, Tilla, 1904- *Beitrag zu den Studien iiber Magenbewegungen und ihre Beeinflussung durch Darreichung von Medika- menten [Tubingen] 16p. 8? [Marktredwitz, O. Trautner, 1931] HERFURTH, Heinz, 1911- *Ueber Gal- Ienwegsdrainage bei schwerem hepatozellularem Ikterus [Berlin] 18p. 8? Heidelb. [n. pub.] 1938. HERGENROETHER, Karl, 1910- *Sym- pathische Ophthalmie nach Glaucomiridektomie bei Aderhaut-Tumor. 16p. 8: Wiirzb., R. Mayr, 1936. HERGESELL, Erich, 1909- histolo- gische Untersuchungen zur Frage der Meningitis serosa [Breslau] p.478-500. 8? Oppeln [n. pub.] 1933. Also Zschr. ges. Neur. Psychiat, 1933, 148: HERHOLZ, Franz Dietrich, 1905- *Ex- perimentelle Untersuchungen iiber Veranderun- gen des Geruchssinnes nach Nasenoperationen. 19p. 2 1. 8? Konigsb., J. Raabe, 1930. HERHOLZ, Gerhard, 1912- *Geno- typische Faktoren bei Kropferkrankungen. 27p. 8: Wurzb., R. Mayr, 1936. HERICOURT, J[ules] 1850- Les fron- tieres de la maladie; maladies latentes et maladies attenudes. xi, 281p. 18y2cm. Par., E. Flam- marion, 1920. ----Le terrain dans les maladies. 248p. 16° Par., E. Flammarion, 1927. HERING, Constantin, 1800-80. The treat- ment of typhoid fevers, with a few additions; a part of the analytical therapeutics. 24p. 4? N. Y., Boericke & Tafel [1873] ---- Condensed materia medica. xv, 870p. 8? N. Y., Boericke & Tafel, 1887. ---- The guiding symptoms of our materia medica. v.6. iv, 650p. 8? Phila., 1888. See also Knerr, C. B. Life of Hering. 347p. 22cm. Phila., 1940. Also Knerr, C. B. Unpublished material from the writings of Constantino Hering. Homoeop. Rec, 1937, 52: 536-49. HERING, Erich [Woldemar] 1901- *Stu- die der Pyorrhoea alveolaris. 102p. 8? Lpz., Oberreuter, 1933. HERING, Erika Margarete, 1909- *Ein Beitrag zur chronischen Leukamie unter be- sonderer Berucksichtigung der Erblichkeit und des Auftretens im hoheren Lebensalter. 52p. 8? Lpz., A. Edelmann, 1935. HERING, Ewald, 1834-1918. Tschermak-Seysenegg [Biography! Munch, med. Wschr, 1934, 81: 1230-3, portr. HERING, H[einrich] E[wald] 1866- Pathologische Physiologie; ein Lehrbuch fiir Studierende und Aerzte. 1. Abt: Die Funktions- storungen des Herzens, der Gefasse und des Blutes. viii, 120p. roy. 8? Lpz., G. Thieme, ---- Die Karotissinusreflexe auf Herz und Gefasse vom normal-physiologischen, patho- logisch-physiologischen und klinischen Stand- punkt (gleichzeitig uber die Blutdruckzugler fiir den normalen und abnormen Kreislauf) vi, 150p. ch. 8? Dresd., T. Steinkopff, 1927. For Festschrift see Zschr. ms. exp. Med, 1026 50: H 1-2 For biography see Klin. Wschr, 1936, 15: 839 (J Rihl) Also Munch, med. Wschr, 1936, 83: 777, portr (H. Lulhes) HERING, Hellmut, 1908- *Die Entgif- tung des Phenylhydrazins. Up. 8? Bresl., K. Vater, 1935. HERING 6C HERING, Hermann, 1896- *Mineral- saurevergiftungen der Mundhohle und ihrer Xachbarorgane (Auszug) 15p. 8? Lpz. [n. pub.] 1923. HERING, Karl, 1896- *Die Anginose Feins und ihre Bedeutung. 19p. 8? Rostock, G. Neumann, 1936. HERING, Kurt Hellmuth, 1901- *Ueber die Minimaltragzeit des reifen Kindes und ihre Bedeutung im Vatcrschal'tsprozess [Leipzig] 51 p. 8? [Zeulenroda, A. Oberreuter, 1930] HERING, Ludolf, 1908- *Untersuchun- gen iiber die ZahnverhiLltnisse von Schulkindern in Ostfriesland [Munster] 21p. 8? Quaken- bruck, R. Kleinert, 1934. HERING [Robert Bernhard] Erwin, 1896- *Inwie\veit hemmen und reizen Salze das Wachs- tum von Bakterien (Auszug) 8p. 8? Lpz., E. Lehmann, 1923. HKRING, Werner, 1910- *Aberglaube und Wahn (an Hand einer Krankheits-Beobach- tung der Univcrsitats-Nervenklinik, Kiel) 23p. 23'2cm. Kiel, H. Liidtke, 1936. HERINGSLAKE, Wilhelm, 1908- *Der Abschluss der Wurzelfiillungen. 30p. 8? Bonn, A. Fieseler, 1933. HERINK, Alfons, 1909- *Untersuchun- gen iiber das Vorkommen und diagnostische Bedeutung des Schweninger Venenkranzes. 26p. 23cm. Berl., F. Linke, 1937. HERIOT, Charles, 1877- *De l'applica- tion du froid dans la conservation des viands et leur utilisation [Alfort] 54p. 8? Par., Rev. Nos Animaux, 1926. HERISEE, Pierre, 1909- *Kssai sur le traitement par la suture immediate des plaies de la main et des doigts par accidents du travail. 51 p. 8? Par, K. Le Francois, 1936. HERKEL, Waher, 1906- *Ueber die Bedeutung des Kupfers (Zinks und Mangans) in der Biologie und Pathologie. p.513-54. 8? Freib. i. B., Fischer, 1930. Also Beitr. path. Anat, 1930, 85: HERKELMANN, Ludwig, 1903- *Ueber Grosse und Ausdehnung der analgetischen Zone nach Injektion vor und in das Foramen mentale. 32p. 2 1. 8? Marb., R. Friedrich, 1934. HERKERT, Arthur. *Adamantinoma solidum [Basel] 18p. 4 pl. 8? Wiesb., J. Bergmann, 1914. HERKERT, Gustav, 1910- *Das Schick- sal der in den Jahren 1918-25 an der Universi- tiitskinderklinik zu Wurzburg an Tetanie be- handelten Sauglinge. 12p. 22'vcni. Wiirzb., G. Grasser, 1936. HERLIN, Emile Oscar Henri, 1896- *Observations sur l'epidemiologie et le diagnostic de la morve [Alfort] 46p. 8? Par., Le Francois, 1926. HERLING, Henner. Editor of Hrldebrandt, Wilhelm Rassenmischung und Krankheit. 122p. 8? Stuttg, 1935. HERLITZ, Carl Gillis, 1902- Studien uber die Prognose der okkulten Kindertuberkulose; eine Nachuntersuehung bei tuberkulinpositiven und tuberkulinnegativen Kindern. 157p. 8? Upps Almqvist & Wiksell, 1937. Forms Suppl. 2, v.19. Acta paediat. HERLITZ, C[arl] W[ilhelm] 1895- Stu- dien iiber die Blutzuckerregulierung bei gesunden S;iugli7)gen und solchen mit exsudativer Diathese 125p. 8° Upps., Almqvist & Wiksell, 1928. Form-, Suppl. 3, v.7. Acta paediat. ---- A contribution to the knowledge of the function of the liver and the reticuloendothelial HERLITZ system, particularly in infectious diseases of children. 80p. 8? Upps., Almqvist & Wiksell 1931. Forms Suppl. 5, v. 12, Acta pccdrat. HERLITZKA, A[medeo] 1872- L'ali- mentazione del popolo in tempo di guerra. lOp. 16? Milano, Hava & ca, 1915. HERLUISON, Henri, 1910- Traitement preventif et curatif des complications grippales par la sulfamido-chrysoidine. 96p. 8? Par., M Vigne, 1937. HERLYN, Karl Ewald, 1902- *Ueber Blutgruppen bei Tieren. p.377-98. 8? Gott Hubert & co., 1928. Also Zuchtungskunde, Gott, 1928, .1: ----& LOHSTOETER, Use. Praktikum der Rontgendiagnostik. 163p. illust. diagrs. 8? Munch., J. F. Lehmann, 1937. HERMABESSIERE, Oswald, 1904- *]M syncope: etude pathogenique; role de la circula- tion de retour. 47p. 8? Par., M. Lac, 1931. HERMAN, Fred Louis, 1894- See Jean, Frank Covert, Harrah, Ezra Clarence, & Herman, F. L. Introduction to science. Book 2, pt I. 197p 8° [Greeley, Col, 1933] HERMAN, Leon, 1886- The practice of urology. 923p. illust. pl. 8? Phila., W. B. Saunders, 1938. HERMAN, Morris, 1908- *The spread of activity in veratrinized muscle [Zurich] 21p. 8? Bruges, Impr. Ste-Catherine, 1936. Also Arch, internat. pharm. dyn. Par, 53. HERMAN, Pierre, 1901- *Contribution a l'etude des formes extra-articulaires de la mal- adie de Bouillaud. 67p. 8? Par., M. Lac, 1929. HERMAN, Samuel, 1903- *Le double souffle crural et sa frequence dans rinsuffisance aortique arterielle. 58p. 8? Par., M. Lac, 1930. HERMAN, William, 1891 1935. Putnam, T. J.. & Ayer. J. B. obituary. Tr. Am. Neur. Ass, 1935, CI: 173. HERMANN, Abraham. *Ueber einige psy- chische Symptome des Alkoholdeliriums. 14p. 8? Basel, Philogr. Verlag, 1934. HERMANN, Andre, 1914- *Fibrome praevia et accouchement spontane. 29p. 2 pl 24cm. Par., Hermann, 1939. HERMANN, Bernhard, 1904- *Identi- fizierung durch Zahne bei Verbrannten [Kiel] 20p. 8? Liibeck, M. Schmidt-Romhild, 1931. HERMANN, Erich. Das Problem des einzigen Kindes in umweltpsychologischer und charakte- rologischer Beleuchtung. 184p. tab. 23}zcm. Lpz., J. A. Barth, 1939. Forms Beih. 80, Zschr. angew. Psychol. HERMANN, Gisela, 1909- *Ueber un- spezifische serologische Reaktionen aus der Universitats-Hautklinik Freiburg i. B. 43p. 8? Quakenbruck, C. Trute, 1936. HERMANN, Gustav, 1897- *Ueber Frak- turen des aufsteigenden Unterkieferastes. 31p. 8? Marb., H. Bauer, 1935. HERMANN, Gustav, 1907- *Ueber Hy- pernephrome—hypernephroide Gewachse—unter besonderer Berucksichtigung ihrer atypischen Lokalisationen mit zwei eigenen derartigen Fallen [Heidelberg] 40p. 8? Bottrop, W. Postberg, 1932. HERMANN, Heinrich [Wolfram] 1905- *Ueber entzundliche Tumoren des Netzes und der Bauchdecken. 40p. 8? Bonn, H. Trapp, 1929. HERMANN, Henri Xavier, 1892- Le coeur. p. 19-351. 8? Par., 1932. In Traits d. physiol. norm. path. (Roger, G. H. & Binet, L.) Par, 1932, 6: HERMANN 601 HERMAPHRODITISM ----Circulation (Fev. 1937 - FeV. 1938) 105p. 25}<>cm. Par., Hermann & cie, 1938. Forms No. 659, Actual, sc. & industr.; Physiol, No. 11. HERMANN, Josef, 1817-1902. Es gibt keine konstitutionelle Syphilis; ein Trostwort fiir die gesamte Menschheit iiber meine Neue Lehre iiber das Wesen und die Heilbarkeit der Syphilis. 8. Aufl., bearbeitet von Dr med. Ziegelroth. 107p. 8? Lpz., C. Ronniger [1910] HERMANN, Joseph [Friedrich] 1873- *Ueber Hirnverletzungen im Anschluss an zwei schwere Falle aus der Bonner chirurgischen Klinik. 47p. 8? Bonn, A. Henry, 1898. HERMANN, Oskar, 1898- *Ueber Jod- ausscheidung nach Einspritzung von Yatren. lOp. 8? Giessen [n. pub.] 1926. HERMANN, Otto, 1898- *Methoden und Ergebnisse von Wasser- und Kochsalz- stofTwechseluntersuchungen bei Pemphigus und anderen Dermatosen. 12p. 8? Miinch., C. Wolf & Sohn, 1931. HERMANN, Pierre, 1903- *Des glau- comes chroniques par contusion. 59p. 8? Par., A. Legrand, 1931. HERMANN, Reiss. Versuch einer mechani- stischen Analyse des Seelen- und Nervenlebens (Grundzuge einer Psycho-Neuro-Physik) 154p. pl. 8? Lpz., J. A. Kienreich Graz [1933] HERMANN, Ruth, 1906- *Beitrag zur Bedeutung des Electrocardiogramms fiir die Beurteilung der Herzinsuffizienz. 19p. 8? Tub., A. Becht, 1933. HERMANN, Sigfrid. Wieder gesunde Fusse; die Giirtelspannung als Grundlage jeder Fuss-, Rumpf- und Haltungskorrektur. 2. Aufl. 48p. illust. 21cm. Frankf. a. M., H. Bechhold, 1938. HERMANN, Werner, 1912- *Beitrag zur Geschichte der Pest in den unteren Donau- landern [Munchen] 15p. 22!-'cm. Bucuresti [n. pub.] 1938. HERMANNI, Const. Philippus. Secreet der philosophien. 24 1. 8? Antwerp., Jan Roelants, 1553. HERMANNI, Walter, 1906- *Zur Frage der primaren Genitaltuberkulose. 26p. 8" Marburg, J. Hamel, 1931. HERMANNS, Ernst August, 1912- *Die Ansiedlung von Bakteriophagen in der Mund- hohle. 26p. 8? Wurzb., R. Mayr, 1936. HERMANNS, Franz, 1907- *Naevus flammeus des Gesichtes und Hydrophthalmus [Munster] 19p. 22>^cm. Wurzb., K. Triltsch, 1936. HERMANNS, Heinrich, 1909- *Die todliche Kohlenoxydvergiftung durch Kamingase, erlautert an den im GerichtsJirztlichen Institut in Diisseldorf untersuchten Fallen [Munster] 18p. 8? Wurzb., K. Triltsch, 1934. HERMANNS, Liselotte, 1910- *Makro- cornea und Buphthalmus. 19p. 22^cm. Greifsw., H. Adler, 1937. HERMANNSEN, Thomas, 1900- *Ueber Abortfolgen. 22p. 8? Kiel [n. pub.] 1929. HERRMANN-TROSS, Achim, 1912- *Erfahrungen mit der Sakralanasthesie. 19p. 22^cm. Miinch. [n. pub.] 1938. HERMAPHRODITISM. See also Genitals, Abnormity; Gynandrism; Intersex; Parthenogenesis; Sex reversal. Berner, O. Hermaphroditismus und sexuelle Umstimmung. 94p. 23^cm. Lpz., 1938. Ossent, A. *Etude sur l'hermaphrodisme. 43p. 22#cm. Geneve, 1939. Satjpe, H. *Hermaphroditismus, sexuelle Hypoplasie und Intersexualitat, 40p. 23cm Lpz., 1937. Auslander, E. M. [On hermaphrodism] Probl. endoer, Moskva, 1940, 5: 82-98.—Benton, F. Both man and woman in one body. Sexology, 1933-34, 1: 684-8.—Binet, A. L'herma- phrodisme. Gyn6cologie, 1937, 36:681-703.—Bottaro, O I, & A^IJlaga' °- E" Hermafroditismo. Prensa mid. argent, 1936, 23: 2771-82.—Cawadias, A. P. Hermaphroditism; a historical approach. Brit. M. J, 1041, 2: 818.—De Vecchi, B L ermafroditismo nella specie umana. Pubb. Ist. anat pat Firenze, 1929-31, art. 3, 13.—Dremliug, A. D. [Hermaphro- ditism] lr. Acad. mil. mid. Kiroff, 1935, 3: 363-70.—Friih- wald. Hermaphroditismus. Derm. Wschr, 1938, 106: 672.— Greenhill, J. P, & Schmitz, H. E. Hermaphroditism and «ex determination. West. J. Surg, 1940, 48: 36-41 .—Herma- phroditism. Radiogr. Clin. Photogr, 1931, 7: 13.—Keller, R. Historical and cultural aspects of hermaphroditism. Ciba Symposia, 1940-41, 3: 400-70.------Wenner, R, & Joel, K. Hermafroditismo. Actas Ciba, Rio, 1941, 8: 1-36.—Krediet, G. [Hermaphroditism] Geneesk. bl, 1930, 28: 199-282.— Kuzmin, P. I. [Hermaphroditism] Klin, med, Moskva, 1925, 3: 404.—Legueu. Hermaphrodisme. Rev. gen. clin. thir., 1926, 40: 646.—McCahey, J. F. The sexes and hermaphro- ditism. J. Urol, Bait, 1939, 42: 1130-4.—Morgulis, B. O. [Problem of hermaphroditism] Klin, med, Moskva, 1930, 8: 531-5.—Moszkowicz, L. Hermaphroditismus und antlere geschlechtliche Zwischenstufen beim Menschen. Erg. allg Path, 1936, 31: 236-444.—Potvin, A. R. A propos d'herma- phrodrsme. Bull. Soc. med. hop. Quebec, 1935, 304-11.— Raynaud, R, Marill, F. G, & Xicduna, R. Hermaphrodisme germinal pur chez I'homme; considerations biologiques. C. rend. Soc. biol, 1939, 130: 655-7.—Worcester. R. G, & Bettinger, H. F. Hermaphroditism. Med. J. Australia, 1942, 1: 56» ---- Casuistics. Backmund, K. *Ein Beitrag zur Kenntnis dee Hermaphroditismus. 78p. 8? Miinch., 1925. Doenicke, A. *Ein Beitrag zur Kenntnis des Hermaphroditismus [Gottingen] 23p. 8? Tiib. 1921. Le6n, N. La Monja Alferez Dona Catalina de Erauso icual seria su verdadero sexo? 40p. 4? Lisb., 1922. Adamson. G. N. Hermaphrodism (report of a case) Clin. M. & S, 1933, 40: 145-7.—Albuquerque, M. C, & Seshacha- lam, T. Notes on a case of human hermaphrodite. Ind. M. Gaz, 1929. 64: 509.—Betts, J. A. A hermaphrodite. Atlantic M. J, 1925-26, 29: 686.—Birt. E. Ein Fall von Hermaphro- ditismus bei einem Chinesen. Zbl. Chir, 1926, 53: 1121-4 — Chappie, H. An unusual case of hermaphroditism. Brit. M. J, 1937, 1: 802 4.—Cohen, L. A case of hermaphrodism. Week. Bull. S. Louis M. Soc, 1933, 27: 509-11— Ferri, G. SuU'ermafroditismo; un caso di ernia strozzata dell'utero in ermafrodite. Osp. maggiora, Milano, 1934, 22: 291-9.— Fuluii, I. Ein Fall von Hermaphroditismus. Jap. J. M. Sc, 1941, 9: Abstr. Anat, 114.—Glaisler, J. A case of herma- phroditism. Lancet, Lond, 1030, 1: 624.—Gomoiu, V, Gomoiu, V, & Simionescu, F. [On hermaphroditism; problem of sexology] Spitalul, 1941, 61: 123-6.—Gyllensviird, N. [Hermaphroditism, with description of 2 cases] Hygiea, Stockh, 1928, 90: 190-210.—Hartley, H. A case of herma- phrodism. Brit. M. J, 1028. 2: 342.—Hynie. J. [Rare case of hermaphroditism] Cesk. derm., 1929, 10: 261-9.—Jeffery, M. P. Report of a case of congenital sexual anomaly develop- ment. Am. J. Obst, 1928, 16: 269 -72. Kohout. J. [Case of hermaphroditism] Cas. 16k. cesk, 1027, 66: 1247-50.—Lhuerre. Presentation de sujets atteints de malformations congenitales. Bull. Soc. path, exot. Par, 1028, 21: 259.—Littauer. K. Erreur de sexe. Arch. Gyn, 1932, 150: 670.—McKinney, J. IMcD. An unusual case of heterogenitalism. Endocrinology, 1925, 9: 229-31.—Malgras & Gricouroff. Hermaphrodite de 63 ans k comportement friminin. M6m. Acad, chir. Par, 1939, 65: 272-6.—Matusis, I. A, & Pavlov, A. N. It ases of herma- phrodism and pseudo-hermaphrodism] Odess. med. J, 1928, 3: 107-12.—Meyer, R. Ein Fall von Keimdriisenzwittrigkeit. Zschr. Geburtsh. Gyn, 1925, 89: 430. Also Zbl. Gyn, 1925, 49: 1872.—Sellheim, H. Ein Neutrum. Arch. Gyn, Berl, 1927, 132: 338-43.—Soler y Dopff, C, Forcada Gelabert, F, & Soler y Dopff, J. Un caso de dismorfismo genital. Arch, med, Madr, 1928, 28: 714-7. Also Rev. med. Barcelona, 1928, 10: 217-24.—Soloviev, N. S. [Undetermined sex in man] Sovet. klin, 1931, 15: 112-21.—Walawelski. H. Ein Fall von tubu- larpr Form von Hermaphroditismus. Zbl. Chir, 1930, 57: 1724-7.—Wetterdal. P. [Case of hermaphroditism] Nord. med, 1940, 8: 2165.—Youmr. H. H. Some hermaphrodites I have met. N. England J. M, 1933, 209: 370-5. ---- experimental. Adams, A. E. Sexual conditions in Triturus viridescens: artificial hermaphroditism. .1. Exp. Zool, 1938, 78: 233-69 — Beccari, N. La inversione sperimentale del sesso nei vertebrati. Boll. Soc. ital. biol. sper, 1929, 4: 1080-1C3— Caridroit, F. HERMAPHRODITISM 602 HERMAPHRODITISM L'intersexunlit6 experimentale chez les gallinaces; ses rapports avec la theorie chromosomique du sexe. Arch. anat. micr.. Par.. 1929. 2."»: 294-308.—Hunphrey, R. R. Adult artificial her- maphrodites in Amblystoma tigrinum and mexicnnum. Am. J. Anat, 1941, 69: 19-59. 3 pl.—Krause, W. Lntersuchungen iiber experimentellen Hermaphroditismus mit Variation der Testikel- und Ovarialmenge. Biol, gen, Wien, 1920, 2: 202- 300, 7 pl.—I.ips»hiitz, A. Experimenteller Hermaphroditismus und der Antagonismus der Geschlechtsdrusen; Hyper (eminie- rung und protrahierte Brunst. Arch. Res. Physiol, 1920, 211: 722-44. —■---- Der Einfluss des Alters des Wirtstieres auf das Zustandekommen des weiblichen hormorralen Etfekts; Schlusswort. Ibid, 745-60.------Experimenteller Herma- phroditismus und der Antagonismus der Geschlechtsdrusen; iiber die Bedeutung spermatogener Substanzeu lui das Zustande- kommen des weiblichen hormonalen Elfekts; Hormon und Substrat. Ibid, 305-23.------ Neue Untersuchungen uber experimentellen Hermaphroditismus und iiber den Antagonis- mus der Geschlechtsdrusen. Ibid, 1028-29, 221: 439-54. ------ Hermaphrodisme experimental par transplantation ovarienne en presence des deux testiculesintacts. C. rend. Soc. biol, 1927, !)7: 501-6.------Nouvelles experiences sur l'hermaphrodisme experimental en presence de testicules in- tacts. Ibid., 1401. ------ Adamberg, L. [et al.] Experi- menteller Hermaphroditismus und der Antagonismus der Geschlechtsdrusen; das Gesetz der konstanten Follikelzahl; die Beeinflussung des ovariollen Transplautals dm ch die Ovarien in situ. Arch. ges. Physiol., 1020, 211: 082-00.—LipschUlz, A, Tiitso, M. |et al.] Die gcschlechtsvcrschiedene Reaktion auf das ovaricllo Transplantat; vergleichende Versuche mit Ovarien- transplantation bei Mfiimchen und Weibchcn. Ibid, 097- 721.—Lipschiitz, A, 7, 1: 1231.—Olbrychl, J. Zwei Falle von Zwittern. Zacchia, 1938, 2. ser, 2: 212-22.—Strassmann, G. Die Lntei-suchiing bei fraglicher Geschlechtszugehorigkeit. In Handb. bio! Arbeitsmeth. (Abderhalden, E.) Berl, 1938, 4: T. 12, 1. Halite, Bd 1, 323-31. ---- Pathogenesis. Albert, Z. Zur Frage der Geschlechtsbcstimmung beim Zwitter. Zbl. allg. Path, 1938-39, 71 : 291-5.—Altenburg, E. A theory of hermaphroditism. Am. Natur, 1934, 68: 88-91.— Baumann, T. Nebenniere, Interienalismus und Hermaphrodi- tismus in neuzeitlicher Fragestellung. Kinderarztl. Prax, 1938, 9: 407-74.—Dantchakoff, V. Sur les facteurs de l'histo- g6n6se chez des hermaphrodites. C. rend. Soc. biol, 1036, 123: 856-8.—Gunther. H. Theoretische und klinische Erorte- rungen uber menschliche Zwitter unter besonderer Beriicksichti- gung des endokrinen Genito-Interrenalsystems. Endokrino- logie, 1029, 5: 440-57.—Levit, S. G. Genetical analysis of selected humnn data bearing on the genetics of hermaphroditism. J. Genet, Cambr, 1037, 35: 151-9.—McCahey, J. F. Herma- phroditism; a new conception. Arch. Path, Chic, 1938 25: 027. Also Surg. Gyn. Obst, 1938, 67: 046-54.—Moszkowicz, I, Die Entstehung des Hermaphroditismus. Wien. klin. Wsehr, 1030, 49: 545-51.—Neumann, H. O. Vererbungs- theoretische Grundlagen zu den sexuellen Zwischenstufen Zschr. Geburtsh. Gyn, 1934, 109: 102-86.—O'Farrell, J. M. Hereditary hermaphroditism; report of 3 cases. J. Am M Ass, 1935, 104: 1908-72.—Parks, H. B. Relationship between the first cleavage spindle and mosaic formation. J. Hered, 1036, 27: 367-76, 10 hg.—Schwarz. E. Zwischenniere und Zwittertum. Med. Klin, Berl, 1027, 23: 300-8. Also Wien klin. Wschr, 1927, 40: 140; 213; 257. Also Wien. med. Wschr ' 1927, 77:.159-61. ---- Pathology. Brieger, F. Ueber die Genetik und Physiologie der Selbst- sterihtrit. Naturwissenschaften, 1927, 15: 734-40 —Gunther H. Beitrag zur Nosologic des Zwittertums und der Anomalien des Gemto-Int\\. TuIjii- lar hermaphrodite with teratoma of the internal genitalia lirit. J. Surg, 1930, 18: 01-5.- Melculfe. R. H. I'rerus masculinus; complete tubular hermaphroditism, with leiato- matous enlargement of an undescended testicle. Ibid, 335- 7.—Moszkowicz, I, Die Prostata der Zwitter und din Svste- rnatik ties Zwittertums. Virchows Arch , 1035, 2U.1: 211 -35.__ Oberlhur. H. Un cas d'hei maphrodile presentant un sGmiuomc abdominal tordu; determination diHiciie du sexe. Mim Acad chir. Par, 1030, 62: 211- 23.—Roinbcrger, J. R, & Simkins, C. S. An analysis of a human ovotestis associated with a con- gcnitally bisected uterus herniated into the iriiuinal canals. Am. J. Obst, 1938, 36: 275-81. -Schapiro. G. Zur Frage dea Hermaphroditismus. Virchow: Arch, h'27. 2(>l>: 302-400.__ Walther, R. Ueber Hermaphroditismus. lieitr. path. Aruit 1035, 95: 207-315.—Weyeneth, R. Sicben verschiedene Typen des Hermaphroditismus externus, glandularis und neuter beim Menschen. Virchows Arch, 1036, 297: 504- 626.—Zawadowsky, M. M. Analyse der Rrscheinungen von Hermaphroditismus. Arch. Entwrneeh, 1020, 108: 531-62.__ Zsako, 1, & Fekete, J. [Hermaphrodism with epileptic feeble- mindedness] Budapesti orv. ujs, 1038, 36: 007-1002. ---- pseudo. See also Gynandrism; Suprarenal, Tumor; Testis, undescended, &c. Kellner, A. *Zwei Falle von Pseudo- hermaphroditismus. 28p. 8? Lucka, 1926. Pas, L. van de. Un caso de pseudo-herma- froditismo. p.3-11. 2G'/,cm. B. Air., 1939. Antonopoulos, D. Hermaphroditismus als Sterilitatsursache. Zbl. Gyn, 1020, 53: 3407-72.—Atcilj, S. Studio radiologico di due casi di pseudoermafroditismo. Radiol, med, Milano, 1926, 13: 77-81.—Beek, C. van (Hyperplasia of the suprarenal cortex and intcrrena! toxicosis in infants with or without pseudo- hermaphroditism] Ned. tschr. geneesk, 1940, 84: 4507-16, 3 pl.—Berner, O. A masculine and a feminine pseudoher- maphrodite. Norsk mag. lxgevid, 1929, 90:217-32. -Brewvter. H. F, & Cannon, H. E. Hermaphroditism; report of case of pseudo-hermaphroditism. N. Orleans M. & S. J, 102') 30 82: 76-80.—Brito, J, & Rihciro, F. E. Pscudo-hermiiphrodi-tme. Bull. Soc. chir. Paris, 1930, 28: 571-6. Also Presse med, "i:',7. 45: 83.—Chacon Enrique, E. Un caso de pseudo-herma- froditismo. An. Hosp. S. Jose, Madr, 1931-32, 3: 237-41.— Chevassu, M. Radiographics du systdme tubulaire d'un pseudo-hermaphrodite injects au lipiodol. Mem. Acad, chir. Par, 1938, 61: 510-2.—Coates, A. E. Pseudo-hermaphroditism. Med. J. Australia, 1027, 2: 122.—Creevy, C. D. Pseudo- hermaphroditism; a report of 5 cases. Internat. Surg. Digest, 1933, 16: 19.5-212.—Crossen, H. S, & Crossen, R. J. Pseudo- hermaphroditism. In their Dis-. Women, 9. ed, St Louis, 1911, 751-9.—Dal Prato, C. SuH'oriidue del pseudoermafroditismo ncll'uomo. Minerva med. Tor., 1028, 8: pt 2, 1354-00.— Davis, W. Pseudo-hermaphroditism occurring in 2 children of the one family. Med. J. Australia, 1927. 1: 800.—De Ni^ris, G. Sopra un caso di pseudoerrnafroditismo. Arch, anliop. crim. Tor, 1030, 50: Suppl, 1488-04.—Dickinson, T. V. Pseudo-hermaphroditism. Proc. IL Soc M, Lond, 1028-2!) 22: Sect. Stud. Dis. Child, 11.--Draper, G. The mosaic of androgyny; maleness within the female and femaleness within the male. N. England J. M, 1041, 225: 393-401.—Est.ipe, J. M, i Delgado Correa, B. Seudo hermafroditismo; sindrome geiiito.suprnrrer.al. Arch. lat. amer. pediat, B. Air, 102'.), 23: 019-20. Also Hev. med. lat. amer, B. Air, 1930-31. 16: 44- >1. Falta, W. Ein Fall von Pseudohermaphroditismus. Wien. khn. Wsehr, 1941, 54: 480.—Finkler, It. S. A case of pseudohermaphroditism. J. Am. M. Ass, 1034, 102: 924. ------ Pseudohermaphrodism; pregnandiol glucuronidate excretion. J. Clin. Endoer, 1941, 1: 151-3.—Gerin, C. Su due casi di pseudoermafroditismo in fratelli. Bull. sc. nvd, Bologna, 1035, 106: 412-6, 4 pl.—Gold, E. Ueber den Eifolg der Rontsenbestrahlung in einem Falle von Pseudohen la- pbroditisiiius nut malignen Nebennierenrindentumoren. Axih. khn. Chir, 1930, 158: 500-8.—Haines, W. H. Pseudo-her- maphroditism. Urol. Cut. Rev.. 1034, 38: 321.—H ilban. J. Pseiidoherinaphrodi'ismus. Wien. klin. Wschr, 1020, 39: 115.—Haynes. E, Thomas, H. P, & Wheeler. M. S. Pseudo hermaphroditism with psychosis; a case report. Med. Rue, -V Y, 1911, 154: 307-9.—Jasienski, G. Un cas dc pseuJo- hcrmaphrodisme. J. urol. med, Par, 1938, 46: 562-4 — Jones, H. O. Pseudo-hermaphroditism (a case report) S. Luke Hosp. Bull , Chic, 1037, 1: 4- (:. Also Am. J. Obst, 1938, 35: 701-3.—Krawzowa, K. T. Ein Fall von Pseudoherma- phroditismus mit seltener Abweiclmng im Bau des Urogenital- systems. Zbl. Gyn.. 1027. 51: S59 02.—Levi. D. Pseudo- hermaphroditism. Proc. U. Soc. M., Lond, 1032. 25: 1234.— Levy, S. K. Pseudo-hermaphrodism; report of case in a new- born. Arch. Pediat, N. Y, 1930, 47: 259-62.—Loforte Goncalves, M. Consideracoes sobre um caso de pseudo-herma- frodismo. Arq. rio grand, med, 1938, 17: 14.5-82, tab.— Long, C. H., Ziskind, J., & Storck, A. H. Dysgerminorna HERMAPHRODITISM 603 HERMAPHRODITISM occurring in a pseudohermaphrodite. Surg. Gyn. Obst, 1941, 73: 811-8.—Millet, I. D, & Kenny, P. J. A case of adrenal cortical hyperplasia, associated with pseudo-hermaphroditism. Brit. J. Surg, 1939-40, 27: 728-33.—Moitas, A. Novo caso de pseudo-hermafroditismo. Med. cohtemp, Lisb, 1930, 57: 131-4.—Neumann, H. O. Analoge Keimepithelblastome der Hoden und der Ovarien sowie ihr Vorkommen beim mensch- lichen Zwitter oder Scheinzwitter. Arch. Gyn, Berl, 1927-28, 131: 477-573.—Orsos, E. Pseudohermaphroditismus und die Zwischenzellen. Deut. Zschr. Chir, 1931, 230: 211-9.— Parhon, C. I, Placinteanu, G, & Ornstein, I. Sur un cas de pseudohermaphroditisme. Rev. fr. endoer, 1938, 16: 341-9.— Pons Tortella, E, & Gallego Berenguer, M. Nota sobre un caso de pseudohermafroditismo con error de sexo. Rev. mid. Barcelona, 1934, 22: 213-7—Pratt, F. W. M. A pseudo- hermaphrodite with suprarenal cortical hyperplasia. Proc. R. Soc. M.. Lond, 1934, 27: Sect. Clin, 305.—Pratt. .LP. Pseudo- hermaphrodism. Tr. Am. Gyn. Soc, (1040) 1941, 65: 199-211. Also Am. J. Obst, 1940, 40: 870-82.—Pryor, H. B, & Brooks. Le R. Two cases oi pseudo-hermaphroditism vi ith a view of some previous cases. Arch. Pediat, N. Y, 1030, 47: 779-83.— Raucb. Pseudohermaphroditen. Deut. med. Wschr, 1927, 53: 1581.—Rey Baiter. C. Pseudohermafroditismo y tumores de las glandulas sexuales. Rev. espan. obst. gin, 1935, 20: 41-9.—Riddell, J. A case of pseudo-hermaphroditism. Brit. M J, 1929, 1: 1040.— Rinck, H. Ueber den Geschlechts- driissenabbau bei einem Fall von Pseudohermaphroditismus. Zschr. ges. Anat, 2. Abt, 1027, 13: 209-11.—Rohlfinsr. LTeber einen Fall von Pseudohermaphroditismus. Zschr. Medbeamte 1926, 39: 457-61.—Rupilius. K. Ein Beitrag zum familiaren Auftreten von Pseudohermaphroditismus. Arch. Kinderh, 1933, 100: 206-10.—Sandomiesky, M. [Cases of false hermaph- rodism] Bebruss. med. misl, 1928, 4: 117.—Sicca, G. Testicolo ectopico invaso da processo suppurativo, in pseudo- ermafrodrto, simulante un'ernia strozzata. Clin, chir, Milano, 1935, 3S: 180-7.—Smith, W. R. Pseudo-hermaphroditism; report of a case. J. M. Ass. Georgia, 1927, 16: 240.—Slern, E. Ueber einen Fall von Zwitterbildung der ausseren Genitalien. Zschr. Kinderforsch, 1931, 38: 685-7.—Stewart, R. M. Pseudohermaphroditism, adiposity, polyuria, and hyper- glycaemia; an infundibulo-tuberian syndrome. J. Neur. Psychiat, Lond, 1938, 1: 68-80.—Torres Torija, J. Un caso curioso de hermafrodismo falso. Gac. mid. Mlxico, 1928, 59: 175-8, 2 pl.—Uimanov, N. A. [Case of complete pseudo- hermaphroditism] J. teor. prakt. med, 1929, 3: 323-7.— Vara Lopez, R, & Sanchez-Lucas, J. G. Sobre 3 casos de pseudo-hermafroditismo; estudio histol6gico. Arch, med, Madr, 1925, 20: 529-35, 3 pl.—Vastola, A. P. Embryonal carcinoma of abdominal testis in a pseudohermaphrodite. ,1. Am. M. Ass.. 1933, 101: ill-4—Vondracek, V., &Nedved, M. [Hermaphroditismus spurius biglandularis] Cas. lek. Cesk, 1941, 80: 293-5.—Wyatt, J. A case of pseudo-hermaphroditism. Proc. R. Soc. M, Lond, 1938-39, 32: Sect. Obst. Gyn, 771-3. --- pseudo, female. See Gynandrism. --- pseudo, male [Androgynia] Halley des Fontaines, J. C. L. Contribu- tion a l'etude de l'androgynie; la notion d'an- drogynie dans quelques mythes et quelques rites. 231p. 8? Par., 1938. Aubert. Un cas d<> pseudohermaphrodite masculin. Schweiz. med. Wschr, 1928, 58: 394.—Binet, A, & Demange. Un cas d'hermaphrodisme androgynoide. Rev. mid. Nancy, 1937, 65: 267-9.—Brachfeld, O. Das Androgynenproblem in der Gegenwart. Zschr. Sexwiss, 1930-31. 17: 425-31.—Cadiz, R, & Lipschiitz, A. Ueber einen Fall von Pseudohermaphrodi- tismus masculinus. Arch. Gyn, Berl, 1933, 153: 593-011.— Cutler, O. I. Male pseudohermaphroditism. Arch. Path, Chic, 1936, 21: 251.—Laffont & Bonafos. Un cas de pseudo- hermaphrodisme masculin de Pozzi (androgynoide) Bull. Soc. obst. gyn. Paris, 1933, 22: 483.—Layral. Un cas d'hermaphro- disme masculin. Loire med, 1930, 44: 292-7.—Liceaga, F. J. Error de sexo; seudohermafroditismo masculino (androginoides) Sem. m6d, B. Air, 1923, 40: 1958-64.—Mariani, A. Un caso di ermafroditismo spurio maschile. Boll. spec. med. chir, 1927, 1: 42-9.—Marin Moreno, N, & de la Fare, M. Seudo- hermafrodismo masculino (error de sexo) Sem. med, B. Air, 1929, 36: 348-50.—Martin, L, & Bonniot. Un cas dp, pseudo- hermaphrodisme androgynoide; refection de l'urStre perineal et penien. Bull. Soc, fr. urol, 1932, 227. Also J. urol. med. chir, 1932, 34: 74.—Martin, W. Pseudohermaphroditismus masculinus. Surg. Clin. N. America, 1929, 10: 535-44.— Monti, G. Pseudo ermafroditismo maschile. Bull. sc. med, Bologna, 1927, 10. ser, 5: 444-50.—Mufioyerro Prete!, A. Un caso de pseudohermafroditismo masculino o androginoidismo. Arch, med, Madr, 1931, 34: 505.—Palhares. C. Um caso curioso de pseudo-hermaphroditismo masculino. Rev. gyn. obst, Rio, 1939, 33: pt 2, 294-306.—Pierquin, C. C. Reflexions sur un cas d'hermaphrodisme et d'hypospadias; Montpellier, 1823 (a review by P. M. Roux) Observ. sc. med, 1823, 5: 266-9.— Pires de Lima, J. A, & Tavares, A. Deux cas de pseudo-hermaphrodisme masculin. Fol. anat. Univ. Conimbr, 1930, 5: No. 9, 1-17, 7 pl.—Puppe, G. Zwitterbildung der ausseren Genitalien, rudimentare Zwitterbildung der Ge- sch echtsgange bei einem rminnlichen Individuum. Deut Zschr gerichtl. Med, 1920, 8: 697-702.—Solomon, T, L. Herma- phroditism ; report of a case of apparently true hermaphroditism with photographs of the woman. Med. Rev. of Rev. 1929 35- 553-8, pl— Ssercljukov, M. G. Zur Frage des miinnlicheii Iseudohermaphroditismus. Endokrinologie, 1931, 8: 184- 91-—Tavernier. Hermaphrodite androgyne regulier. Lvon chir, 1937, 34: 242-50.—Usandizaga, M, & Sanchez Lucas', G. Hermafroditismo masculino. Arch, med, Madr, 1931, 34: 373-8. Also Rev. espan. obst. gin, 1931, 16: 685-990.— Vulpes. Descruione delle mostruosita delle parti genitali di un individuo sotto le divise di donna. Ann. clin. Osp. incurab Nap, 1836, 2: 217-21.—Wert her, R. The sorrows of Jennie June landrogyne] Am. J. Urol, 1919, 15: 160-5. ----• pseudo, male: Complete type. Unshelm, E. *Ein klinisch bemerkenswerter Fall von Pseudohermaphroditismus masculinus completus [Bonn] p.318-329. 8? Berl., 1927. Also Virchows Arch, 1927, 265: Assim, A. Ueber einen Fall von Pseudohermaphroditismus masculinus completus. Zbl. Gyn, 1935, 59: 691-4.—Schultze, G. K. F. Pseudohermaphroditismus masculinus externus et internus. Ibid, 1930, 54: 1173-80. ---- pseudo, male: External type. See also Hypospadias. Jacobs, E. *L)er Hermaphroditismus mascu- linus externus in seiner Bedeutung fiir die chi- rurgische Diagnostik (eine klinische und ent- u-icklungsgeschichtliche Studie) [Munster] 37p. 22cm. Wiirzb., 1934. Halbin, I. Pseudohermaphroditismus masculinus externus et internus et secundarius. Miinch. med. Wschr, 1926, 73: 349. Also Wien. med. Wschr, 1926, 76: 167.—Healey, C. E, & Guy, C. C. Pseudohermaphroditismus masculinus externus associated with suprarenal hyperplasia and vascular hyper- tension; report of a case. Tr. Chicago Path. Soc, 1931, 13: 517-38. Also Arch. Path, Chic, 1931, 12: 543-61.—Jahr [Pseudohermaphroditismus masculinus externus] Deut. med. Wschr, 1926, 52: 1451.—Lauwers, G. B. [External male pseudohermaphroditism] Ned. tschr. geneesk, 1936, 80: 4186- 90, 2 pl.—Sponsel. Demonstration eines Falles von Pseudo- hermaphroditismus masculinus externus. Zbl. Gyn, 1925, 49: 1869-72. ---- pseudo, male: Internal type. Winkler, B. *Ueber einen Fall von Pseudo- hermaphroditismus masculinus internus. 25p. 8? Zur., 1893. Davidovic, S. Ueber einen Fall von Pseudohermaphroditis- mus masculinus internus. Zbl. Chir, 1926, 53: 70-2.— Geissler, J. Zur Kenntnis des Pseudohermaphroditismus masculinus internus. Beitr. path. Anat, 1937, 99: 305-28.— Josselin de Jong, R. de. Ein Fall von Zwischenzellenge- schwulst in einem ektopischen Hoden bei Pseudohermaphro- ditismus masculinus internus. Frankf. Zschr. Path, 1926, 34: 420-31, pl.—Oiye, T. On 2 cases of pseudohermaphroditismus masculinus internus. Mitt. allg. Path, Sendai, 1927-28, 4: 317-44, pl.—Seemen, H. von. Pseudohermaphroditismus masculinus internus; Kryptorchismus; Hernia inguinaiis congenita. Beitr. klin. Chir, 1927, 141: 370-9.—Szekely, L. Seltener (operierter) Fall von Pseudohermaphroditismus masculinus internus. Zbl. Chir, 1930, 57: 3168-71.—Vieira Filho, J, & Toledo, O. de. Sobre um rarissimo caso de pseudo- hermafroditismo masculino interno. Arq. polic. civ. S. Paulo, 1941, 2: 329-44. ---- Psychological, and social aspect. Boehm, F. Ueber den Weiblichkeitskomplex des Mannes. Internat. Zschr. Psychoanal, 1930, 16: 185-209.—Bryan, D. Bisexuality. Internat. J. Psychoanal, Lond, 1930, 11: 150- 66.—Jackson, J. A, Pike, FL V, & Ashenhurst, I. Pseudo- hermaphroditism in a mental patient. Med. J. & Rec, 1928, 128:232. Also repr.—Kvint, L, & Ge^hvandtner, R. [Herma- phroditism and homosexuality] Ukrain. med. arch, 1927, 1: 178-95.—Moszkowica, L. Gibt es Beziehungen zwischen Hermaphroditismus und Homosexualit:it? Klin. Wschr, 1930, 9: 1509-72.—Patry, F. L. Theories of bisexuality, wdth report of a case. Psychoanal. Rev, 1928. 15: 417-39— Polozker, I. L. Report of a case of a patient who considers himself a hermaphrodite. J. Nerv. Ment. Dis, 1932, 75: 1-21.— Schmidt, L. [Psychology of hermaphroditism] Gy6gy£szat, 1935, 75: 805.—Torres Torija, J. , Problema medico-social suscitado con motivo de un hermafrodismo falso. Gac. mid. Mexico, 1933. 64: 534-42.—Valentin. B. Die soziale Bedeutung des Pseudohermaphroditismus und ahnlicher Missbildungen. Deut. med. Wschr, 1929, 55: 873-5.— Villinger, W. Psychische Hygiene und Scheinzwittertum. Zschr. psych. Hyg, 1934, 7: 51-6. HERMAPHRODITISM 604 HERMAPHRODITISM Treatment. \le\iindre, A. Problemi posti al chirurgo di froute a un ch.no !i p- n.i -ermafroditismo. Minerva med. Tor, 1935, 26: pt 2, 574 0.— .Vita. S. Two operated cases of hermaphro- ditism. Jap. J. M. Sc. 1034-30, t: Surg. &c, 220.—Corrective surgery in hi i maphroditism. South. M. & S, 1940, 102: 721). —('ode. .1. Injection de rfrum anti-ovaire k un coq gvnandromorpho; modifications raciales consecutives. C. rend. Soc. biol, 1924, 91: 1252-4.—De Napoli, F. La bis- scssnaliti come carattere individuale costante e relative; opo- terapia antiomoscssuale. Bull. sc. med. Bologna, 1923, 10. ser.. 1 : 230. Also Rass. stud, sess., 1023, 3: 229- 1 1. Edmunds. A. Pseudo-hermaphroditism and hvpospadias; ibeir surgical treatment. Lancet, Lond, 1020, 1 : 323-7, 2 pl. l.'llis. E. I, H. A ease of pseudo-hermaphroditism and its treatment. Ibid, 1037, 2: 17.—Golianitzki, J. A. Ueber das Zwittertum und seine chirurgisehe Behandlung. Arch. klin. Chir, 1027, 144: 732-51.—Gusynin, V. A. [Uretroplasty in surgical adjustment of the sex in hermaphrodites] Khirurgia, Moskva, 1038, No. 12, 109-14.—Gyllensviird, N. Ein operierter Herma- phrodit. Acta obst. gvn. scand, 1930, 10: 302-409.—Halban, J. Spontane Geseli'eelitsumwandlung eines Zwitters. Schweiz. med. Wschr, 1030, 6C: 1130-2.—Kakuschkin, N. Ueber chirurgische Eingriffe bei Zwittertum zwecks Verweiblichung. Arch. Frauenk, 1933, 19: 150-00.—Meisner, K. Ueber Opera- tionen an Hermaphroditen. Med. Klin, Berl, 1929, 25: 986.—Moszkowicz, L. Ueber Operationen an Hermaphro- diten. Ibid, 517-9.—Odasso, A. Ermafroditismo e pseudo- r-rmnfrodrtismo. Arch. ital. chir, 1030-31, 27: 45-81.— Padon. F. Ptiine osservazioni sulle gonadi di un teleosteo ermafrodi'a, Ilepatus hepatus L, trattato con ormone fem- minile. Momi. zool. ital, 1939, 50: 129-32.—Schmidt, A. [Operative treatment of hermaphroditism] Gvogv.lszat, 1935, 75: 804. Also Orv. hetil, 1936, 80: 719-22. 'Also Urol. Cut. Rev, 1941, 45: 535 (Abstr.)—Should orchidectomy be per- formed in pseudohermaphroditism? J. Am. M. Ass, 1037, 109: 884.—Wells. T.. J. Reproductive organ? of 2 mammalian hermaphrodites and their response to injections of pregnant mare serum. Anat. Rec, 1936-37, 67: 233-48, 2 pl. ---- true. Ombredan.ve, L. Les hermaphrodilcs et la chirurgie. 322p. 25^cm. Par., 1939. Andrecvit. Z. A. [Cases of true hermaphrodism] J. akush, 1028. 39: 715 -28.—Bogliolo, I, Intorno ad un caso di probabilc ennalrodiliMuo vero; con alcune considerazioni sulla cosidelta intersessualita nella specie iimana. Arch. ital. anat. pat, 1933, 4: 8^9-944.- Cornil & Brossard. Un cas de coexistence dans la tunique vaginale d'un uterus, de 2 trompes et de 2 testieules. Rev. gyn. chir. abd. Par, 1008, 12: 105-202.— Dess, A. K, »v Pncstlev, J. T. True hermaphrodism; report of a ease. .1. Urol, Bait, 1940, 43: 859-05.--Essenbcrg, J. M, li, A. Variazioni e anomalie dcH'organo di Bidder quale contributo all'ermafroditismo della gonade degli anfibi anuri. Atti Accad. fisiocr. Siena, 1925-26, 9. ser, 17: 555-81, 2 pl. ; - Lo studio dell'organo di Bidder in rapporto al tipo di vanazione nei B. vulgaris Laur. e B. viridis Laur. Ibid, L-j i ^j sor'' '" 331-47.------Recherches sur l'organe de Bidder des bufonides en rapport k 1'dtude de l'hermaphrodi- trsme de la gonade des amphibies anoures. Arch. ital. biol, 1927-28 78: 29-34.—Chevey, P. Observation sur une perchc hermaphrodite (Perca fluviatilis Linn.) Bull. Soc. zool. France, 1022, 47: 60-4.—Christensen, K. Hermaphroditism in Rana prprens. Anat. Rec, 1029, 43: 345-58.—Comas, M. Sur 1'intersexualite chez Parainerrnis contorta V. Linst. Bull. biol. France, 1927, 61: 186-9, pl. —Crew. F. A. E, & Munro, S.S. Gynandromorphism and lateral asvminetry in birds. Proc. R. Soc. Edinburgh, 1937-38. 58: 114-34, pl.—Curson, H. H. Anatomical studies, No. 52: Two cases of false masculine her- maphroditism in cattle (Path. Nos. 5018 & 11125) Onderste- poort J. Vet. Sc, 1935, 4: 503-9.—David. J. D, & Shah. K. MY. Case of hermaphroditismus transversalis femininus in a calf with imperforate anus. Ind. Vet. J, 1941-42, 18: 173, pl.— David, R, & Caullery, M. M. Sur la structure hermaphrodite des testieules chez certains males de Talitrus saltator Mont. HERMAPHRODITISM 605 HERMAPHRODITISM C. rend. Soc. biol, 1035, 118: 526-8—Devie, R. Les problemes de la sexualitd vus en fonction de 1'hermaphroditisme chez le crapaud. Recipe, Louvain, 1939-40, 4: 407; 443—Dob- zhansky, T. Interaction between female and male parts in gynandromorphs of Drosophila simulans. Arch. Entwmech, 1930-31, 123: 719-46.—Donisthorpe, H. Gynandromorphism in ants. Zool. Anz, 1929, 82: 92-6.—Dragiou. I, & Pop. E. Un cas d'hermaphrodisme glandulaire chez la grenouille (Rana temporaria) C. rend. Soc. biol, 1927, 96: 1451-4.— Dreyfus, A. Hermaphroditismo alternante proterogynico em Rhabdias fulleborni Trav. Mem. Inst. Butantan, 1937, 11: 289-97, 3 pl. ------ Sobre o mecanismo de formac.ao dos espermatozoides nas zonas testiculares da. forma parasita de Rhabdias fulleborni Trav. Rev. biol, S. Paulo, 1937-38, 8: 5-9, pl.—Duclaux, G. Un cas d'hermaphrodisme chez le cheval. Bull. Soc. sc. vdt. Lyon, 1901, 4: 297.—Duvelleroy. Un cas d'hermaphrodisme chez le cheval. Ibid, 254.— Eaton, O. N, & Simmons, V. L. Hermaphrodism in milk goats. J. Hered, 1939, 30: 261-0.—Eggert, B. Der Herma- phroditismus der Tiere; Beitrag zur Intersexualitat der Anuren. Zschr. wiss. Zool, 1029, 133: 503-85.—Fankhauser, G., & Moore, C. Cytological and experimental studies of polyspermy in the newt, Triturus viridescens; the behavior of the sperm nuclei in androgenetic eggs, in the absence of the egg nucleus. J. Morph, 1941, 68: 387-420, 2 pl.—Fekete, E. A case of lateral hermaphroditism in Mus musculus. Anat. Rec, 1937, 69: 151.—Florentin & Prudhomme. Un cas d'hermaphrodisme glandulaire bilatdral k ovotestis chez le pore. Rec. mdd. vdt, 1937, 113: 801-0.—F^lger, A. F. A case of hermaphroditism with pregnancy in a pig. Acta path, microb. scand, 1932, Suppl. 11, 143-50.—Forgeot, E. Observation d'un cas d'herma- phrodisme dans l'espdce bovine; hermaphrodisme externe et tubulaire masculin. Bull. Soc. sc. vdt. Lyon, 1902, 5: 140-2.— Fourie, J. Anatomical studies, No. 54: False masculine hermaphroditism in a pig (Path. No. 12926) Onderstepoort J. Vet. Sc, 1935, 4: 573.—Furrow, C. L. Development of the hermaphrodite genital organs of Valvata tricarinata. Zschr. Zellforsch, 1934-35, 22: 282-304.—Gabler, H. Zwei Falle von Zwittergonaden bei Clupea harengus L. Zool. Anz, 1930, 91: 72-5.—Gladow. Zwitterbildung beim Pferde. Berl. tierarztl. Wschr, 1928, 44: 368.—Goldschmidt, R, & Fischer, E. Erblicher Gynandromorphismus bei Schmetterlingen. Arch. Entwmech, 1927, 109: 1-13, 2 pl.—Goldschmidt, R, & Katsuki, K. Erblicher Gynandromorphismus und somatische Mosaikbildung bei Bombyx mori L.; vorlaufige Mitteilung. Biol. Zbl, 1927, 47: 45-54. ------ Zweite Mitteilung uber erblichen Gynandromorphismus bei Bombyx mori L. Ibid, 1928, 48: 39, 685.—Guilhon, J. Un cas d'hermaphrodisme chez un bovin. Rec. mdd. vdt, 1938, 114: 449-52.—Harvey, E. B. An hermaphrodite Arbacia. Biol. Bull, 1939, 77: 74-8, 2 pl.—Hubbs, C. L. A study of gynandromorphic katydids. Am. Natur, 1927, 61: 283-5.—Hughes, W. The freemartin condition in swine. Anat. Rec, 1929, 41: 213-31, 8 pl.—Hughes-Schrader, S. Origin and differentiation of the male and female germ cells in the hermaphrodite of Icerya purchasi (Coccidae) Zschr. Zellforsch, 1927, 6: 509-40, 3 pl.—Huxley, J. S, & Bond, C. J. A case of gynandromorphic plumage in a pheasant re-examined in the light of Lillie's hypothesis of hormone threshold. J. Genet, Cambr, 1934, 29: 51-9, pl.—Ikeda, K. Cytogenetic studies on the self- fertilization of Philomycus bilineatus Benson (studies of hermaphroditism in Pulmonata) J. Sc. Hiroshima Univ., 1936-37,ser.B,Div. 1,5:67-123, pl.—Jackson,H.G Hermaph? roditism in Rhyscotus, a terrestrial isopod. Q. J. Micr. Sc, Lond, 1927-28, 71: 537-9.—Jaffe, H. L, & Papanicolaou, G. N. A case of hermaphroditismus verus lateralis in a guinea pig. Anat. Rec, 1927-28, 36: 20.5-20.—Katsuki, K. Untersuchungen iiber erblichen Gynandromorphismus und somatische Mosaikbildungen bei Bombyx mori L. Zool. Jahrb, Abt. allg. Zool, 1927, 44: 1-84, pl, 2 ch. ------ Weitere Versuche uber erbliche Mosaikbildung und Gynandro- morphismus bei Bombyx mori L. Biol. Zbl, 1928, 48: 43-9.— Kaura, R. W. A bovine hermanhrodite. Vet. J, Lond, 1933, 89: 186, pl.—Krediet, G. [The origin of ovariotesticles in connection with sex inversion] Tschr. diergeneesk, 1927, 54: 1-24. ------ [Ovariotestis in the scrotum of a pig] Ibid, 1928, 55: 910-8. Also Ned. tschr. geneesk, 1928, 72: 234. ----- Intersexualitat oder Hermaphroditismus bei Siiuge- tieren. Zschr. ges. Anat, 1. Abt, 1929-30, 91:251-91. _ [Genital organs of an intersexual shote with 2 ovariotesticles] Tschr. diergeneesk, 1932, 59: 194-202, 3 pl.—Kremer, J. Adulter Hermaphroditismus bei Rana temporaria. Anat. Anz, 1934-35, 79: 106-12.—Kusnezov, N. J. The morphology of the copulatory structures in some cases of gynandromor- phism in Lepidoptera. Biol. Bull, 1926, 51: 245-50.—Lagos Garcia, C. Hermafroditismo verdadero en un ave. Sem. mdd, B. Air, 1929, 36: 2-0.—Lamoreux, W. F. A pseudogynandro- morph in the fowl. J. Hered, 1939, 30: 79—Langeron, M. Un cas d'hermaphrodisme chez un poisson. C. rend. Soc. biol, 1932, 110: 3.—Lantz, L. A. Hermaphroditisme partiel chez Lacerta saxicola. Bull. Soc. zool. France, 1923, 48: 289.— Lebedeff, G. A. Genetics of hermaphroditism in Drosophila viriiis. Proc. Nat. Acad. Sc. U. S, 1934, 20: 613-6. AIi'o repr.—Lengerken, H. von. Ueber die Entstehung bilateral- symmetrischer Insektengynander aus verschmolzenen Eiern. Biol. Zbl, 1928, 48: 475-509.—Lloyd, J. H. Hermaphroditism in the common frog (Rana temporaria) Am. Natur, 1929, 63: 130-8.—Macrides, J. Un cas d'hermaphrodisme chez un pore. Rec. mdd. vdt, 1940, 116: 18-23.—Mergelsberg, O. Ueber die postimaginale Entwicklung (Physogastrie) und den Hermaphroditismus bei afrikanischen Termitoxenien (Dipt) (zugleich ein Beitrag zur Entwicklung der Eizellei Zool Jahrb, Abt. Anat, 1935, 60: 345-98, pl.—Merton, H. Unter- suchungen fiber Entstehung und Natur des Kinoplasmas in den Zwitterdriisen der Pulmonaten. Zschr. Zellforsch 1931 13: 202-35—Moller-Sorensen, A. Die operative Behandlung dreier Iiille von Pseudohermaphrodisrnus masculinus beim Pferde. Berl. tierarztl. Wschr, 1037, 53: 430--2.—Moore. G. A, & Byers, E. A case of hermaphroditism in Rami cates- beiana Shaw. Tr. Am. Micr. Soc, 1038, 57: 407-11 pl— Moszkowicz, L, & Kolmer, W. Ein gynandromorphes Huhn. Virchows Arch, 1030-31, 279: 768-79.—Neefs, Y. Sur divers cas d'hermaphrodisme fonctionnel chez Poursin Strongvlo centrotus lividus. C. rend. Acad, sc, 1937, 204: 000-2.— Niefcon, P. E. Report of a case of true lateral hermaphroditism in Sus. Anat. Rec, 1041, 80: 1-11, 2 pl— Oordt, G. J. van. Zur Sexuahtat der Gattung Epinephelus (Serranidae, Teleostei) Zschr. mikr. anat. Forsch, 1933, 33: 525-33.—Ostertag, H. Ueber glandularen Hermaphroditismus beim Schwein nnter besonderer Berucksichtigung des histologischen Bildes. Frankf. Zschr. Path, 1937-38, 51: 344-02.—Peacock, A. D. Studies in the parthenogenesis and sexuality of saw-flies (Tenthre- dinidaO a gynandromorph of Pteronidea (Nematus) ribesii Scop.,with observations on gynandromorphism and saw-fly sexuality. Brit. J. Exp. Biol, 1925-26, 3: 01-84, 2 pl.— Pearson, N. E. The structure and chromosomes of 3 .gynandro- morphic katydids (Aniblycorypha) J. Morph, 1929, 47: 531-47, 3 pl.—Perrot, J. L. Sur lactivitd des spermatozo'rdes au niveau du canal hermaphrodite de l'Helix pomatia. C. rend. Acad, sc, 1937, 204: 1305 7.—Pezard, Sand & Caridroit. Les hormones sexuelles et le gynandromorphisme chez les gallinacds (dtude de biologie experimentale) Arch, biol. Par, 1926, 36: 541-647, 16 pl.------[Periodical gynandro- morphism in a rooster] Ugeskr. laeger, 1926, 88: 653.—Phillips, J. Mel, Brief, B. J. [et al.] Hermaphroditism. J. Am. Vet. M. Ass, 1939, 95: 663-74.—Pollister, A. W. The occurrence in the hermaphroditic prosobranch, Valvata tricarinata, of typical spermatozoa only. Anat. Rec, 1941, 81: Suppl, 77 (Abstr.)—Puri, I. M. A case of gynandromorphism in Simu- lium. Ind. J. M. Res, 1933, 20: 801, pl.—Rey. Deux exemples d'hermaphrodisme dans le cheval, et un cas d'hypo- spadias sur un agneau. J. mdd. vdt, Lyon, 1840, 2: 230-40.—■ Riddle, O, Dunham, H. H, & Schooley, J. P. Genetic hermaph- roditism in a strain of pigeons. Genetics, 1942, 27: 165.— Risley, P. L. Some observations on hermaphroditism in turtles. J. Morph, 1941, 68: 101-21.—Roberts, J. A. F, & Greenwood, A. W. An extreme free-martin and a frce-martin- like condition in the sheep. J. Anat, Lond, 1028-29, 63: 87-95.—Roberts, S. J. False masculine hermaphrodite. Cornell Vet. 1940, 30: 52-0.—Sewell, L. Hermaphroditism in a dog. Vet. J, Lond, 1920, 82: 140-3.—Timofeev-Ressov- sky, H. A. Gynandromorphen und Genitalien-Ahnormitaten bei Drosophila funebris. Arch. Entwmech, 1928, 113: 254- 60.—Tollner, W. Pseudohermaphroditismus bei der Ziege. Arch. wiss. prakt. Tierh, 1924, 50: 205-13.—Toumanov, K. Deux cas de gynandromorphisme biparti chez Dixippus moro- sus Br. et Redt. C. rend. Soc. biol, 1927, 97: 1388-90.------ Le gynandromorphisme chez Dixippus (carausius) morosus Br. et Redt. Bull. biol. France, 1928, 62: 388-411. Viljoen, N. F, & De Bruin, J. H. On a false masculine hermaphrodite in an avian hybrid (anatomical studies No. 59) Onderstepoort J. Vet. Sc, 1935, 5: 351-6.—Wheeler, W. M, & Weber, N. A. Unusual prevalence of sex-mosaics (gynandromorphs) in a. colony of a Trinidad ant. Rep. Brit. Ass. Advance. Sc, 1935, 392.—White, M. J. D. Evidence for polyploidy in the hermaph- rodite groups of animals. Nature, Lond, 1940, 146: 132.— Whiting, P. W. The relation between gynandromorphism and mutation in Habrobracon. Am. Natur, 1028, 62: 59-6'..!. —----& Whiting, A. R. Gynandromorphs and other irregular types in Habrobracon. Biol. Bull, 1927, 52: 89-120, pl.— Winogradow, P. P. Zwei Falle von Hermaphroditismus bpi Schweinen. Anat. Anz, 1929, 67: 475-9.—Witschi, E. The chromosomes of hermaphrodites, Lepas anatifera L. Biol. Bull , 1935, 68: 263-7.—Yonge, C. M. Protandry in Teredo norvegica. Q. J. Micr. Sc, Lond, 1926, 70: 391-4.—Zundel, A. Quelques faits tdratologiques. J. mdd. vdt, Lyon, 1806, 22: 114-20. ---- in plants. Ernst, A. *Uebcr Pseudo-Hermaphroditismus und andere Missbildungen der Oogonien bei Nitella syncarpa (Thuill.) Kutzing [Zurich] 77p. 23^em. Munch., 1901. Mendiola, N. B. Imperfect hermaphroditism in flowers of Hibiscus, removed by surgical operation. Philippine J. Sc, 1927, 32: 65-74, 4 pl.—Showalter, A. M. Hermaphroditism in a dioicous hepatic. Proc. Nat. Acad. Sc. U. S, 1027, 13: 369-72.—Sorokin, H. Cytological and morphological investi- gations on gynodimorphic and normal forms of Ranunculus acris L. Genetics, 1927, 12: 59-83. HERMBSTAEDT, Segismundo Federico, 1758- 1833. Roldan y Guirrero, R. Dr. Segismundo Federico Hermb- staedt, 1758-1833. Bol. farm, mil, Madr, 1933, 11: 142. HERMEIER 606 HERMETO HKRMEIER, Karl, 1907- *Zur Aetiolo- gie der post operativen Thrombose und Embolie. 51p. K? Halle, H. John, 1936. HERMELINGMEIER, Georg, 1906- *Zur Pharmakologie des Harnstoffs [Kiel] 30p. 8? Warburg, Werth, 1930. HERMEK, Jeannot Sundel, 1897- * Ueber die Kinverleibung von gallensauren Salzen in die Blutbahn und deren Ausscheidung (zugleich ein Beitrag zur Frage des Icterus dissociatus) 18p. 8? Lpz. [P. Radestock] 1927. HERMES, Hermann, 1904- *Beitrag Sur Differentialfarbung und Ziichtung des Para- tuberkelbazillus. 30p. 8? Lpz., C. & E. Vogel, 1934. HERMES, Marvin J[ohn] 1908- ♦Mesen- teric thrombosis. lOp. 4? Hollywood, Calif., 1933. Typewritten. HERMESMEIER, Heinrich, 1905- *Ueber die Beeinflussung der Dehydrierungs- vorgange im Gewebe durch Cholsaure und Cho- leinsiiure [Munster] 13p. 8? Werne-Lippe, F. Grube, 1933. HERMES von Liidinghausen, Hans Joachim, 1904- *Die anatomischen Grundlagen des Verschlussmechanismus der weiblichen Harn- blase. p.757-66. 8? Konigsb. i. Pr., J. Raabe, 1931. Also Zschr. ges. Anat, 1. Abt, 1932, f»7: HERMES Trismegistos. Hermetica; the an- cient Greek and Latin writings which contain religious or philosophic teachings ascribed to Hermes Trisnie^istus; ed. with English transl. and notes by Walter Scott. 4v. front. 8? Oxf., Clarendon press, 1924-36. CONTENTS Vol. 1. Introduction, texts and translation. 1924. Corpus Hermeticum. Libellus. Asclepius. Stobaei Hermetica. Fragmcnta. Vol. 2. Notes on the Corpus Hermeticum. 1925. Vol. 3. Notes on the Latin Asclepius and the Hermetic excerpts of Stobaeus. 1920. Vol. 4. Te-itiiiionia with introduction, addenda and indices by A. S. Ferguson. 1936. ---- Asclepius [comm. by S. Champier] p.39-48b. 8? Lyon, 1507. In Champier. De quadruplici vita. Lyon, 1507. ---- The same [comm. by Lucius Apuleius of Madaura] p.473-543. 32? Lyon [1577] In Jamblichus. De mysteriis Aegypti. Lyon, 1577. ---- Centiloquium. p.23b-25b. 4? Venezia, 1501. In Abu Bakr al-Hasan Ibn al Ehasib. Liber nativitat, Venezia, 1501. ---- The same. Centum aphorismi. p.85-9. sm. 4? Basel [1533] In Collect, astron. Basel, 1533, 2. pt ---- Pimander; or, De sapientia et potestate Dei [ed. et transl. by Ficino Marsiglio] 32 1. 8? Venezia, Damianus de Mediolano, May 10, 1493. ---- The same. 42 1. 4? [Venezia, Johannes Hamann (or Lichtenstein) ca. 1500] ---- The same. p.361-473. 32? Lyon [1577] See Jamblichus. De mysteriis Aegypti. Lyon, 1577. ---- The same. noi/iav8pys [ed. Francois de Foix; Greek and Latin text] 68 1. 4? Bor- deaux, Simon Millanges, 1574. ■--- Table d'esmeraude [transl. by Jacques Girard de Tournus] p.35-8. 32? Lyon [1557] In Baco, R. Le miroir d'alquim, Lyon, 1557, 1. pt See also Wellmann, M. Marcellus von Side als Arzt und die Koiraniden des Hermes Trismegistos. 50p. 8? Lpz, 1934. Also Jennings, H. Die hermetischen Philosophen." In his Rosenkreuzer, Berl, 1912, pt 1, 22-7. ------ Die herme' tischen Briider. Ibid, 35-41. HERMETO, Sebastiao, jr. *Perfuracoes intes- tinaes no curso da febre tvphoide; seu tratamento 154p. S? S. Paulo [n/pub.] 1931. ---- *Contribuicao para o estudo da tdenica e da tatiea das paratire6idectomias. 120p illust. 8? S. Paulo [n. pub.] 193S. HERMIGNY de Bruce, Robert E. d\ 1898- *Agents reputes caneerigenes et terrain cancen- sable [Lille] 63p. 23}2cm. Par., L. Rodstein, 1934. HERMODSSON, Ivan Ludwig, 1901- . Rontgenologische Studien iiber die traumatischen und habituellen Schultergelenkvenenkungen nach vorn und nach unten. 173p. 16 pl. 8? Stockh., H. Ohlsson, 1934. Forms Suppl. 20, Acta radiol. HERMS, Hellmut, 1910- *Peritonitis tuberculosa [Kiel] 32p. 8? Hamb., P. Evart, 1936. HERMS, William Brodbeck, 1876- Medi- cal entomology with special reference to the health and well-being of man and animals. 3. ed. xix, 582p. incl. portr. illust. 24cm. N. Y., Macmillan co., 1939. For portrait, photograph, see collection in library. ----& GRAY, Harold Farnsworth. Mosquito control; practical methods for abatement of dis- ease vectors and pests, xii, 317p. illust. pl. diagr. 26cm. N. Y., Commonwealth Fund, 1940. HERMSDORFF, Guilherme Edelberto, 1899- *Acuarioses des oiseaux domestiques [Alfort] 70p. 8? Par., Vigot freres, 1929. HERMSMEIER, Friedrich. Experimentell- psychologische Untersuchungen zur Charakter- forschung; vergleichende Prufung der Methoden zur Untersuchung der ethischen Begriffe und Gcfiihle. 230p. 8? Lpz., J. A. Barth, 1931. Forms Beih. 55, Zschr. angew. Psychol. HERMSTEIN, Alfred. 1892- Schwan- gerschaftsstotungen. p.483-529. Lpz., C. Ka- bitzsch, 1928. In 3 Bd, 1 Halfte, Handb. inn. Sekret. (Hirsch) HERNAMAN-JOHNSON, Francis, 1879- Radiotherapy in relation to general medicine. ix, 21 lp. 16? Lond., Oxford Univ. press [1926 HERNANDEZ, Alberto, 1912- *Les intersexualites de la puberte masculine et leur importance dans la pathogenie des troubles sexuels de l'adulte. 115p. 24^cm. Par., J. Haumont, 1938. HERNANDEZ, Eusebio. Ramirez-Olivella, J. M. El Dr Eusebio Hernandez en la guerra y en la paz. Rev. mdd. cubana, 1926, 37: 587-600, portr. HERNANDEZ, Francisco, 1514-78. Lejeune, F. Die hinterlassenen Briefe des Leibarztes Philipps II., Francisco Hernandez; ins Deutsche ubertragen und bearbeitet. 41p. 8? Greifsw., 1924. Paoli, H. J. Vieisitudes de las obras de Francisco Herntindez, 1514-78. Archeion, Santa Fd, 1940, 22: 154-70. HERNANDEZ, Francisco J., -1940. Quevedo Baez, M. Nuestro homenaje al Dr Francisco J. Herndndcz. Bol. As. mdd. Puerto Rico, 1940, 32: 377-80, portr. HERNANDEZ, Ismael Maria. Antecedentes, titulos y trabajos. 24p. 23cm. B. Air. [n. pub. 1940. HERNANDEZ, Oscar J., 1905- *Re- cherches sur la broncho-dilatation. 32p. 25cm. Par., J. Haumont, 1939. HERNANDEZ, Rafael, 1897- A labora- tory guide to microscopic anatomy; with direc- tions for laboratory studies in cytology, histology, organology, and embryology, xii, 108 1. 28cm. Ann Arb., Edwards bros, 1937. HERNANDEZ 607 HERNIA ---- Applied neuroanatomy. 123 numb. 1. illust. pl. tab. 21){ x 21^cm. Ann Arb., Ed- wards bros, 1941. HERNANDEZ, Venancio J., 1867- Rodriguez Boscan, H. Doctor Venancio Hernandez. Rev. Soc. med. quir. Zulia, 1941, 15: 1389-97, portr. HERNANDEZ y Gonzalo, Pedro. Oto-rino- laringologia practica. 190p. illust. 8 pl. 24cm. Habana, Ed. Minerva, 1939. HERNANDEZ de Gregorio, Manuel, 1771- 1833. Manuel Hernandez de Gregorio; primer boticario de ejdrcito, 1771-1833. Bol. farm, mil, Madr, 1933, 11: 339-41. HERNANDO, Teofilo. Wechselbeziehungen zwischen den Storungen der inneren Sekretion und dem Verdauungsapparat. lllp. 8? Halle, C. Marold, 1926. Forms II. 8, v.9, Samml. Verdauungskr. HERNDON, Audell. See Stogdill. Z. E. L, & Herndon, A. Objective personality study. lOOp. 27},cm. N. Y, 1939. HERNE BAY, Eng. Queen Victoria Memorial Hospital. Queen Victoria Memorial Hospital, Heme Bay. Med. Press & Circ, Lond, 1937, 194: 1. HERNIA. See also under names of protruding viscera as Brain, Hernia, &c; also under names of contain- ing walls, canals, foramina, and regions of the body as Diaphragm, Hernia; Groin, Hernia, Iason, A. H. Hernia. 1325p. 27cm. Phila., [1941] Patel, M. Hernies. 540p. 24J^cm. Par., 1924. Watson, L. F. Hernia; anatomy, etiology, symptoms, diagnosis, differential diagnosis, prog- nosis, and the operative and injection treatment. 2. ed. 591p. 26cm. S. Louis, 1938. Babcock, W. W. Hernia. Proc. Interst. Postgrad. M. Ass. N. America H940) 1941. 180-4.—Bancroft, F. W. Hernia. Pennsylvania M. J, 1030-37, 40: 63-70.—Bates, W. The hernia problem. Med. World, 1042, 60: 105-7.—Coley. B. L. Hernia. In Cyclop. Med. (Piersol Bortz) Phila, 1939, 7: 225-66.—De Talsats, G. Hernia. Hygeia, Chic, 1939, 17: 886-9.—Fsrgres, H. Uebersicht uber die Hernienliteratur der Jahre 1929-33. Chirurg, 1934, 6: 310-5.—Finney, J. M. T. Hernia. Proc. Interst. Postgrad. M. Ass. N. America, 1933, 61-6.—Fiske. F. A. Hernia. In f \ clop. Med. (Piersol-Bortz) Phila, 1939, serv. vol, 862: 10 10, serv. vol, 824. Also Med. Pec, N. Y, 1941, 154: 287-90.—File, W. P. Hernia. J, Oklahoma -M. As«, 1926. 19: 325—Hagler, F. Hernia. Hygeia, Chic, 1936, 14: 131-3.—Koontz, A. R. Hernia. In Pract. Libr. M. & S. (Appleton) N. Y, 1933, 4: 829-88.— Magee, R. K. Hernia. Canad. M. Ass. J, 1939, 40: 264-7.— Porter. A. R, jr. Hernia. Memphis M. J, 1938, 13: 198: 200.—Rives, J. D. The general principles of hernia. Phi Chi 0, Menasha, 1935, 32: 42-8.—Sircar, P. Hernia. Ind. M. Rec, 1933, 53: 361—Thiry. Les hernies. Presse mdd. beige, 1868-69. 21: 325; 333; 349.—Thomsson, G. Do you have a hernia9 Health, Mount. View, 1942, 9: No. 4, 7.—Toland, C. G. Hernia. Pacific Coast M, 1935, 2: No. 2, 22-5.—Town- send. E. M. Hernias. Virrrinia M. Month.. 1926-27, 53: 221-9.—Turner, G. G. Hernia. In Brit. Encycl. M. Pract. (Rolleston, H.) Lond, 1937. 6: 470-512. --- adipous [Lipocele] Bayer, K. Ein noch nicht bekannter Fall von hypoga- strischer Liparocele. Arb. Geb. klin. Chir, 1903, 44-0.— Bettn, O. Finestre, lacunee tasche della linea alba nella pato- genesi delle ernie lipomatose manifeste ed occulte. Arch. ital. chir, 1939, 56: 546-68.—Cammarano, P. Un caso di lipocele strozzato. Morgagni, 1934, 76: 1051-3— Denoc. Hernie adipeuse; erreur de diagnostic; gudrison. J. med. vet, Lyon 1845, 1: 262-6.—Patten, C. J. Lipoma in the site of a femoral hernia. Brit. M. J, 1909, 1: 1059. --- Age incidence. Jacobi, U. *Hernien im Greisenalter nach dem Material der Leipziger Chirurgischen Uni- versitats-Klinik in den Jahren 1931 bis 1935 [Leipzig] 23p. 23^cm. Zeulenroda, 1937. Benson. R A, & Grossman, L. Strangulated hernia in a premature infant. Bull. N. York M. Coll, 1940, 3: 237-0 — Beukema. W. [Case of strangulated hernia in an infantl Geneesk. tschr. Ned. Indie, 1940 80: 2816.—Blanc Fortacin, J. Lstrangulacion herniaria en los nifios. Actas Coner espan obst. gin. pediat, 1911, 2. Congr, 261-6.—Blevins, W. J. Hernia in the infant with a report '-■f 31 cases. Surg Gvn Ob«t, 1932, 55: 505.—Breakstone. B. H, & Sewell. A. M. Strangulated hernia in an 18-day old baby; operation with recovery. Am. Med, 1926, n. ser, 21: 323.—Brnner. J. W. An unusual ca.—Hennig, K. Hernia intraabdomitialis unter dem Bilde eines stiel- gedrehten Ovarialtumors. Mschr. Geburtsh. Gvn, 1926, 73: 74 6. Heselcr, O. Zur Differentialdiagnose der Unterleibs- hriiche und Tuuioren ill Bi uchgegenden. Ibid, 1033, 94: 277-81. Hinrirhsen, H. M. Subkutaner Bauchwandbruch, als llainaloni iiiiponierend. Zbl. Chir, 1927, 54: 1757-9.— jaurell. H. Leber die Knntgin untersuchung von Bruchen, inslicsondeie klinisch schwer zu diagnostizierenden Formen. Acta radio!., Stockh, 1020, 10: 462-98, 2 pl.—Ljvraga, P. Contributi semeiologici alln diagnosi delle ernie. Arch. ital. chir, 103o, 41: 800-77.—Martinez Olascoaga, I), & Aguerre K.-cardo, A. Sobre un caso de diagno-iico complcjo. Bol. Inst, radiol. cancer, Montev, 1031, 1: 33-13.—Rosenzweig, I. S. | Roentgen diagnosi- of a rare form of hernia] Klin, med.. Moskva, 1030, 14: 1705.—Soffel, J. A. Differential diagnosis ,.f hemic. .M,,l. Times, N. Y, 1937, 65: 291.— Wardleworth Nuttall, H. C. The load test for hernia. Clin. .!.. Lond.. 1035, 64: 425.—Zieman, S. A. The diagnosis of liemia. .1. Am. M. Ass, 1940, 115: 1873. ---- encysted. Schroeder. F. Ueber Entstehung und histologischen Aufbau der Hernia encystica. Deut. Zschr. Chir, 1931. 232: 408-12.—• Seifert. E. Die Hernia encystica. Ibid, 1932, 236: 81-o!— Teneff, S. Sull'ernia encistica. Arch. ital. chir, 1937 46- 106-16. ---- Etiology. Fuhk.maxs, R. *Ueber Vorkommen, Erbge- bundenheit und Behandlungsergebnisse bei 300 Bruchkranken [Munchen] 39p. 8? Quaken- bruck, 1935. Azevedo, T. de. Predisposicao hereditaria para as hernias Brasil med, 1030. 44: 848— Bilmann, H. S. [Hernia as sign of intra-abdominal cancer] Ugeskr. laeger, 1925 87- 847__ Birkenfeld, W. Ueh-r die erbliche Herniendisposition. Arch khn Chir, 1930, 158: 509-32.—Cook, J. B. A hereditary tendency to hernia. Lancet, Lond, 1042, 1: 367 —Evans P A hereditary tendency to hernia. Ibid, 293.—Golianitzky i' A. [Pathogenesis of abdominal wall hernias] Nov khir Moskva, 1925, 1: 3; 387; 300—Hernia need not be'health menace; poor diet and bad posture are contributing causes Hygeia, Chic, 1936, 14: L-Kiss, O. [Preformed portal o he»ua] Orvosk(spz&> 1934, 24: nov. kulonf. (Verebdly Fest- schr.) 177-84.-Matzuev I. E. [Hernia, due to ptosis of various organs] \est. khir, 1930, 20: 242-7—West L S &l^^m5i?f76?herit6d predisp°sition t0 W"k external. See also Abdominal wall, Abnormities. Bu.mm, E. Die jiusseren Abdominal-Hernien 331p. X? Berl., 1931. Bartlett, R. W. Fundamental considerations underlying tlio origin and care of external abdominal herniae. Week. Bull S Louis M. Soc, 1038-30, 33: 300-4.—Costa, G. Ernie esterne ed addome acuto. Clin, chir, Milano, 1030, n. ser, 12: ,">ll)- 05.—Eggers, H. Die l.ehre von den ausseren Hernien. In Chirurgie (Kirschner & Nordmann) Berl, 1927, 5: 61-126, 16 pl.—Hohlbaum, J. Aeussere Hernien. Diagn. ther. Irrtiim 1926, H. 8, 181-244.—Wakeley, C. P. G. Treatment of certaiii types of external herniae. Lancet, Lond, 1940, 1: 822-0. ---- Forensic, and occupational aspect. Devy, J. F. *La hemic, accident de travail existe-t-elle? 71p. 8? Par., 1938. Favre, C. F. *Contribution a l'6tude du traitement chirurgical de la hernie accidentelle 17p. 8? Ziir., 1910. Armentrout, C. R. Hernia and its effect on the industri.il worker. South. M. J, 1936, 29: 630-3.—Batchelor. R. |>. Hernia in its relation to the compensation law. Atlant ir M I 1020-27, 30: 683-7.—Benkovich, G. [Intestinal hernia after abdominal subcutaneous injury] Orv. hetil, 1937, 81: 741- 4.—Boulloche, P. Hernie; iStat morbide ant(5rieur; pus d'acci- dent du travail. Rec. spic. accid. trav., 1031, 34: 205-7. ------ Hernie resultant d'un etat morbide preexistant; Loi de 1898 inapplicable. Ibid, 1030, 36: 121-3.—Bravo, J. Hernias accidentes,-en la nueva Lev de Aeeident.es del Trabajo' Med. ibera, 1933, 27: pl 2, 300-14.—Brisard, C. A propos de la hernie. Rec. sp^c. accid. trav, 1033, 33: 33-0.--Campos L, F. J. Las hernias ante los accidentes del trabajo. Cir & eirujan, Mex, 1033, 1: 183-203. Also Riv. mid., Puebla, 1935- 36, 8: 14; No. 66, 16; 1030-37, 9: No. 68, 10.—Capocaccia, M. Su di un caso di ernia infortunia e sul concetto di neeessit.a e di urgenza dell'intervenlo chirurgico. Gazz. internat. med. chir, 1931, 3!): 707 76. -Casati, E. La hernie et la contusion entero- peritonealo en rapport avec les accidents. Ann. med. iig., 1936, 16: 445 -5 I.—Caso, G. Le ernie traumatiche. Fol. med. Nan. 1035, 21: 312-20.- Clark, W. I. Hernia in employees of a grinding wheel factory. Boston M. & S. J, 1027-28, 197: 1314-0.—Coley, W. B, Leigh, S. [et al.] Traumatic and indus- trial hernia; report of the special Committee of the Medical Section of the American Railway Association. Tr. West Sur" Ass. (1921) 1022, 31: 311-32. Also Ann. Surg, 1922, 75: 467- 77. -Davis, J. Traumatic hernia. N. York State J. M, 1937, 37: 1 128-30.—Davis, J. W. Hernia and the compensation law. South. M. A: S, 1031, 93: 581.—Descoust, P. H. Considera- tions lnedico-legales sur la hernie traumatique ou plutot sur la hernie traiimat isee a la suite d'efioi ts. Ann. med. leg, 1939, 19: 441-5.—Erdman, S. Hernia and the workmen's compensa- tion act. Yale J. Biol, 1933, 6: 83.—Fallis, L. S. Industrial aspects of hernia. Med. Rec, N. Y, 1010, 152: 432-4.— Fallon, C. E. The hernia situation at a plant employing 1,000. Indust. M, 1938, 7: 060-2.—Fernandez.Speroni, C. La hernia como accidente de trabajo. Rev. crim, B. Air, 1930, 17: 691- 6.—Firmeza, H. Hernia doenca e hernia acidente. Impr. mod, Rio, 1939, 15: 1517-21.—Garton, H. W. Compensable hernia. J. Indiana M. Ass, 1930, 23: 521-0.—Giordano, D. Dell'ernia traumatica quale infortunio sul lavoro. Riforma med, 1933, 49: 1885-8.—Green, C. C. Hernia in railroad employees. South. M. J, 1935, 28: 649-53.—Health insurance; postoperative hernia and inability to follow a gainful occupa- tion. J. Am. M. Ass, 1936, 107: 238.—Herbst, R. Leber einen Fall echt traumatischer Hernie. Zbl. Chir, 1020, 56: J291-3 -—--- Zur Frage der traumatischen Hernien. Mschr. Unfallh, 1930, 37: 2 1-3,0— Hernie (Sur la) traumatique ou plutot sur la hernie | ramnatiseV k la suite d'efforts. Concours med, 1940, 62: 1155. Hirshfield, F. R. Hernia in heavy industry. Indust. M, 1038, 7: 72.—Holland, J. H. Hernia from the compensation insurance standpoint. N. England J. M, 1933, 209: 579-85. Hopkins, C. W., Leigh, S. [et al.] Accidental or compensable hernia; report of the Committee of the American Railway Association. Ann. Surg, 1929, 90: 1000-8.—Iason, A. H. When is hernia compensable? Indust. M, 1942, 11: 3-0.— Jacquet, H, & Oltramare, J. H. Quelques remarques a propos d'une hernie soi-disant traumatique. Praxis, Bern, 1936, 25: 469.—Johnston, R. L. Hernia in indus- try; review of the cases during the past 10 years. Indust. M, 1940, 9: 85-7. Johnstone, R. T. Hernia. In his Occup. Dis, Phila, 1941, 421-34.—Kerns, I. N. Relation of trauma to hernia. Kentucky M. J, 1938, 36: 133.-Kirschner, M, & Muller, E. Leber den ursachlichen Zusammenhang zwischen Unfall und Bauchbruch unter besonderer Beriicksichtigung der Rechtslage des Unfallversicherungsgesetzes. Chirurg. 1030, 11: 465-80. Lauderdale, T. L. Observations on the so-called traumatic hernia. Texas J. M, 1927-28, 23: 800-3. Levy, L. H. Occupational hernia: prevention bv theinjection method. Indust. M, 1938, 7: 75 8. -Lyonnet, P. Hernies et accidenti du travail. Bruxelles med, 1938-39, 19: 1096. Also Ann. med. leg, 1030, 19: 377-80.—M'Glannan, A. Causation or aggravation of hernia. U. S. Labor Statist. Bur. Bull, 1923, 9: L>8-G4. Marin, R, J. La hernie como enfermedad profesional proveniente d» uu accidente del aervicio. Congr. med. cir. HERNIA 609 HERNIA nav mil. Chile, 1929, 1. Congr, 331-6.—Matuck, A. Hernia e accidente do trabalho. Arch. Soc. med. leg. S. Paulo, 1939, 10: gg —Mazel, P, & Heger, M. A propos de la hernie accident. Ann mie Ingan M. Soc, 1933, 34: 438. -Holmes, J. M. A case of pi'.peritoneal hydrocele. Brit. J. Surg, 1932, 20: 346-8.- St John. V. [Pathogenesis of properit"ileal hernia] Rev. chir, Bucur, 1920, 21: 416-30. ------- Preperitoneal hernia and mass reduction of strnagulated hernia. Wot. J. Surg, 1933, 41: 183-90.- Wilensky, A. O, A. Gordon. J. D. A ease of interstitial hernia. Am. J. Surg, 1030, 45: 330. ---- intra-abdominal. Alexander, F. K. The roentgen diagnosis of intra-abdominal hernia. Am. J. Roentg, 1937, 38: 92-101.—Bennett, R. J, jr. Intra-abdominal hernia; report of 2 cases. Am. J. Surg, 1930, 34: 374.—Brohee, G. Les hernies parajejunales retroperi- tori£ales ou hernies de Treitz et de Wahicyer. Arch. mal. app. digest.. Par, 1031, 21: 704 -812.--Chesterrran, J. T. Cnhnie internal heinia. Brit. .1. Mirg., 1941-42, 29: 278.— Divis, J. | Peritoneal hernias] (a.-, lek. cesk.. 1932. 71: 961 — Klston. L. W. Intra-abdominal beiiLi.es with report of case. .1. Indiana M. Ass, 1920, 19: 157 -9.—Fmenhiser, L. K, & Pankratz, D. S. Left intraperitoneal hernia; case report. Am. .1. Mini., 1936. 34: 104-0.—Erdely, G. Ueber die um die Fli-Miia duodenojeiunalis geleeeneu Briiche. Deut. Zschr. f'lnr.. 1927. 2'J.>: 120-5.--Folliasson, A. Hernies internes. Gaz. le.".. 1930, 103: 1545; 158.3. AI.-d Ann. anat. path. Par, 1931, 8: 47-52.—Halpert, B. Left :, u uine-ooelic hernia. Surgery, 1039, 5: 379-81.—Hamilton, H. IL, cv_ Kniyht, B. L. An internal hernia through a broad ligament. .1. Iowa M. Soc, 1034, 24: 490.—Hansniann, G. H, & Morton, S. A. Intra- abdominal hernia; report of a case and review of ihe literature. Arch. Surg, 1030, 39: 073-86.—Jackson, B. H. Hernia of the small intestines into the lesser peritoneal cavity; report of a case. Am. J. Surg, 1930, n. ser, 8: 1065-7.—Johns, W. A. Intra-abdominal hernia. \irginia M. Month., 1039, 66: 020-3.-■ Malcolm, R. B. Two cases of hernia into peritoneal fossae. Canad. M. Ass. J, 1927, 17: 449.-Mason, R. F. Im la-abdonnnal herida with re| ort of case. Memphis M. J, L9 11, 16: 77 80.—Masson, J. C, & Atkinson, W. Heinia- into the broad ligament and remarks on other intraabdominal ln-inias. Tr. Am'. Gyn. Soc, 1031. 59: 188-96. Also Am. J. Obst, 193L 28: 731 8.—Mayo, C. W, Stalker, K. I,, & Miller, J. M. Im ia-al domunil le-tnia; review of 39 cases in whieli treatment was surgical. Ann. Surg, 1941, 114: 875 -So. - Mrszaros, K. [Internal hernia caused by the falciform liga- ment | Orvoskepzes. 1939, 29: Decembeii kulonf. No. 2, 7il 2.--Miller, J. M. Intra-abdominal hernias as a cause of in- te-rinal obstruction. Proc. Mayo Clin, 1940, 15: 359-62.— Moritsch, P. Zui Kasiii-.tik liniiiiT Hernien. Deut. Zschr. Chir., 1933. 240: 014 L'3. Ramnnalhan, S. A ease ol intra- abdominal liemia wiih stiamculaiion. .1. ('ej Ion Brit. M. Ass, 1938, 35: 82-4. Rappoport, 1. G. [Pericecal hernia] Vest. khir, 1930, 19: 370 '■',. — Roschdvslwenskij, K. G. Line none Art von Peritoniialbruch. Henna iliocolica, Jazuta. Virchows Arch, 1932, 2»6: 240.—Savin, V. M. [Internal herniasl Nov. khir. arkh, 1941, 49: 208-70.— Steinke. C. R. Internal hernia, 3 additional ca- reports. Arch. Surg, 1932, 25: 909-25. Also repr.—\ aides. L. Hernia interna pericecal. An. Sanat. Valdes, 1027. 3: 1 V! 9 -Wildegans, H. Die inneren Bauch- briiche (mit Au-nehmo der Zwerchfellbriiche) Erg. Chir. Orthop, 1935, 28: 237-88. ---- Littre's. See under Intestine, Diverticulum. ---- Military aspect. Hook. F. R. Ventral hernia; as a sequel of the traumatic abdomen. I". S. Nav. M. Bull, 1936, 34: 440-52. 5 pi- Line of dun status in cases of hernia. Army M. Bull, 1927, 1-7. — Morisson. Les hernieux dans l'arm^e; leur aptitude physique et, leur situation par rapport au service a court terme et k la loi des pensions. Bull. Soc. m6d. mil. fr, 1928, 22: 22-9.—Petrovitch, M. [Ueber die Hernien] Voj. san. glasnik, 1932, 3: 217-05.—Santorsola, D. Le ernie addominali dal punto di vista militare e sociale; obbligatorieta deU'intervento. Arch. ital. chir.. 1030, 44: 096; 1937, 43: 858. —Stephens, H. E. R. Abdominal hernia in the Royal Navv. Proc. IL Soc. M.. Lond.. 1920-27. 20: Sect. War, 15-23. Also J. R. Nav. M. Serv, 1927, 13: 197-207. ---- multiple. Brendolan, G. Associazione in uno stesso individuo di due ernie a caratteri non comuni. Ann. ital. chir, 1933, 12: 397-400.—Costache Diinita. | Ventral polymicro-hernia] Spi- talul, 1935. 55: 153-5—Giampietro. F. Caso di ernia doppia operata. Filiatre sebe/io, Nap.. 1840, 19: 281-3-McClarin, W. M. The multiple bendae. Kentucky M. .1, 1938. 36: 235.—Navak. K. M. A case of double heinia. Ind. M. Gaz, 1924, 59: 348. ---- partial [Richter] Angel, E, & Angel, F. Richter's hernia. South. M. & S.' 1937, 99: 275-7—Bis^ell. A. H. Richter's hernia; including a case of intra-abdominal suture of sac. Am. J. Surg, 1929, n. ser., 7: 864-6. Blotzek, A. 'Richter's herniae] Vrach. gaz.. 1920. 30: 406.—Bolin, G. W. Richter's hernia with Si'i in I a neons fecal fist u la . 1 epoi I of a Ca.-e. Hosp. News, Wash 1010, 7: No. 7. 1-12. Cattell. R. B. Hi.ht, i\ hernia. Surg' (Ijti. Obst., 1933. 50: 7DD -1. Rhodes. R. I, Partial enlcrii- cele; Richtei's, Littre's hernia. Tr. South. Surg. Ass., 192S, 41: 175-87. Wilson, G. E. Richter's hernia: report of 2 casts J. Am. M. Ass, 1934, 102: 1938-40. ---- Pathology. Cherner, M. Direct and indirect hernia in the light of the newer interpretation of the anatomy of the anterior abdominal wall. Am. J. Surg, 1030, 44: 593 -600.—DantchacofT, K. Importanza della insuflicienza valvolare delle vene nella etiologia delle ernie da sforzo; supplemento della cura radicale. Policlinico, 1038, 45: sez. prat, 087. -Eliot, E. Transthoracic abdominal hernia. Tr. Am. Surg. Ass., 1933, 51: 101-6. Also Ann. Surg, 1933, 98: 581-6.—-Pinardi. G. Contributo also studio delle ernie rare. Clin, chir, Milano, I92H, 29: 004-92.—Roeder, C. A. The relatiuu of subperitoneal fat to abdominal hernia. Minnesota M, 1926, 9: I 1 I 8. Valiashko, G. A. [1'alhogenesis of abdominal heinia--; hvpei plastic proee-ses] Omsky med. J, 1929, 4: 13 5. Wright. J. A. Hernia of small bowel plugging perforation in large bowel. Chin. M. J, 1936, 50: 1665. ---- postoperative [and incisional] See also Abdomen, Surgery: Complications; Abdominal wall, Surgery: Complication. Besnard, F. *Hernics de l'intestin a travers les dechirures de l'uterus au cours d'interventions. 74p. 8? Par., 1927. Horn, F. [F. E. It.] *Der Erfolg der Operation bei Bauchnarbenbruchen. 23p. 8? [Greifsw.] 1935. Leibrandt, R. *Bauchbruche nach Opera- tionen und ihre Si cllung in der Sozialver.sicherung. 42p. 8? Bresl., 1938. Scherf, C *Ueber Hernien nach Laparoto- mien [Bern] 34p. 8? Neuenburg, 1902. Schulte, W. *Ueber postoperative Bauch- briiche [Kiel] 34p. 8? Bochum, 1933. Bachman, H. W. Incisional hernia; factors in the cause and prevention. Virginia M. Month, 1920-30, 56: 232.—Bailey, B. A note on strangulated incisional hernia. Lancet, Lond, 1928, 2: 812.—Baldwin. J. F. Postoperative eventration. Am. J. Surg., 1930, n. ser., 10: 78 -Benjamin, A. E. Incisional hernia and its repair. Minnesota AI, 194 1. 24: 164-8.—Biesen- berger, H. Zur Operation der Nabob und postoperativen Bauchwandhernien. Wien. med. Wschr, 1932, 82: 723-7 — Branch, C. D. Incisional hernia; analv-is of 300 cases. N. England J. M, 1034, 211: 949-52— Cave, H. W. Incidence and prevention of incisional hernias. .1. Am. M. Ass, 1933, 101: 2038-42.— Coates, A. E. Incisional hernia. Med. J. Australia, 1038, 1: 7-11.—Craig, R. L. Postoperative ventral hernia; an analysis of 79 cases following 7,072 laparotomies. Rep. Surg. Staff Woman Hosp. State JL York, 1925-28, 6: 303-9.—Darbois & Sorel. Note sur un cas d'^ventration post- operatoire. Bull. Soe. radiol. med. France, 1029, 17: 248-50 — Dickson. A. R. Postoperative or ventral hernia; a method for relief of tension after repair. Surg. Gyn. Obst, 1935, 61: 830.—Glinkina, E. I. | Post operative eventration] Akush. gin, 1037, No. 6, 97-101 Greenhill, J. P. Repair of post- operative hernia. Am. J. Surg, 1035, 27: 523-8. Also repr.— Gutierrez. A. Frenicectomia y eventracion abdominal post- operatoria. Rev. cir, B. Air, 1038, 17: 501-4.—Harild, S. [Transplantation of fascia in postoperative ventral hernia] Ugeskr. laeger, 1030, 92: 1059-62. Heineck, A. P. Post- operative or incisional hernias of the anterior and lateral abdominal wall. Med. W^orld, 1934, 52: 555-62. Also Illinois M. J, 1935, 67: 529-37. Also West. J. Surg, 1935, 43: 33-9.— Hepburn, J. J. Treatment of postoperative ventral hernia. N. En-land J. M, 1931, 204: 1035-7.—Hinton, J. W. The extraperitoneal operation for massive post-operative hernia. Surg. Clin. N. America. 1939, 19: 453-8— Holtermann, C. Leber postoperative Eventerationen. Mschr. Geburtsh. Gvn, 1929, 83: 81-3.—Johnson, D. W. Prevention and treat- ment of incisional ventral hernia. Minnesota M, 1939, 22: 459-61.—Kinu, E. S. .1. Incisional hernia. Brit. J. Surg, 1935-36, 23: 35-44--Kini, M. G. Incisional hernia. Ind. M. Gaz, 1938, 73: 743.—Kisman. [Cicatricial hernia] Ge- neesk. tschr. Ned. Indie, 1941, 81: 2315.—Koontz, A. R. Preserved fascia in hernia repair with special reference to large postoperative hernias. Arch. Surg., 1933, 26: 500-9.—Lamson, O. F. Transplant for repair of postoperative ventral hernia. Tr. A--. Phv-icians Mayo Clin. C1925) 1920. 6: 99-104. pl. Also Sur<£. Gvn. Obst.. 1020, 43: 388.—McNealy, R. W., & Lichtenstein, M. E. Postoperative hernia; a consideration of etiological factors. Am. J. Surg.. 1932, IS: 90. -Marques de Almeida, E, ID.—Courty, L. Les enterorragies conseculives a l'£tramd. ment. herniaire. J. sc. med. Lille, 1921, 39: 445- 55.—Cruickshank, L. G. Strangulated hernia. Brit. M. J., 1942, 1: 452.—Da Costa, A. F. W. A case of strangulated hernia. Ind. M. Gaz, 1935, 70: 24; 1936, 71: 585—Davidov, G. M. [So-called reducible strangulated hernia] Vest, khir, 1920, 8: No. 23, 102-0.—Delia Mano, N. Ernie strozzate e pentoniii. Arch. Soc. ital. chir, 1933, 39: 718-29.—Di Paola, (i. Infarto rstensivo del ileon y hernia estrangulada. Bol. Soc. cir. B. Aires, 1932, 16: 902.—Donadio, N. Osservazioni cliniche su cento casi di ernia strozzata. Gazz. internaz. med. chir, 1931, 39: 487.—Donald, C. Strangulated internal henna in a retro-appendicular parucaecal pouch. Brit. J. Surg, 1929-30, 17: 103-00.- Douglas, D. M. Strangulated hernia; a consideration of some factors affecting the mortality. Brit. M. J, P.I42, 1 : 354-7.—Dunphy, J. E. Strangulated hernia; a icpoit of 2 cases in \\ Inch the >ac was found in an unusual loea- u.hi. N. England J. M, 1939, 220: 819. Also repr.—Fisher, L. M. Some unusual forms of strangulated hernia. Med. J. Australia, 1928, 2: 023-6.—Fowler, A. Two unusual cases of strangulated hernia. Brit. J. Surg, 1930-31, 18: 528-31 — Frankau, C. Strangulated hernia: a review of 1,487 cases. Ilud, 1931, 19: 170-91.—Franke, E. Invagination bei gan- granosen Hernien. Zbl. Chir, 1927, 54: 265. Fulton, R. H. Miaugulale.l henua. .Med. J. Australia, 1938, 1: 73-5.— Geist, G. A. Suaugulated hernia. Minnesoia M, 1934, 17: 143-5.—Ginzburg, L, ec Klein, E. Large iui.stinal stenosis following strangulated hernia. Ann. Surg, 1928, 88:204-11.— Gioja, E. Due casi non comuru di ernia strozzata. Gazz. internaz. med. chir, 1928, 33: 152-6.—Giordano, D. Ernia strozzata in vecchia. Riforma med, 1933, 49: 857-9.— Godoy Alvarez, M. Hernia estrangulada. Rev. cienc. med, Mex, 1929, 8: 261-9.—Green, E. K. Strangulated hernia through the foramen of Winslow, report of case. Minnesota M, 1927, 10: 151-3.—Grynberg, N. [Case of internal strangu- lated hernial Polska gaz. lek, 1928, 7: 248.—Guha Niyogl, N. K. A strangulated hernia. Ind. M. Gaz, 1935,'70: 82.— Harvey, P. G. Hernia strangulated inside a prolapsed and inverted colon. Lancet, Lond, 1937, 1: 384.—Huckell, R. Strangulated hernia. Brit. M. J, 1934, 1: 1004.—Hume. J. B. Strangulated hernia. Lancet, Lond, 1939, 2: 1308-10.—Hunt, P. S. Strangulated hernia. Med. J. Australia, 1934, 1: 662.— Iliescu, M. O, & Constantinescu, M. N. [Case of post-opera- tive, strangulated eventration] Spitalul, 1930, 50: 126.— Iliescu, M. O, & Nelepcu, C. [Case of strangulated, retro- grade hernia (W-hernia)] Ibid, 1929, 49: 00-2.—Jennings, F. D. Strangulated hernia. Am. J. Surg, 1929, n. ser, 6: 435-7.—Kemm, N. Strangulated hernia. Bristol Med. Chir J, 1931, 48: 151-4— King, M. K. Two strangulated hernias 48: 151-4.- over 80 ye No. 21, 13-5.—Kopilov, F. A. [Retrograde strangulated hernia] Vest, khir., 192(3, 6: 194-8.—Lagos Garcia, C, arm\ erschlinguni im Bruchsaek. Arch. klin. Chir, 1933, 174: 500 U- Mc.sclovsky, F. M. K'liuieal course of strangulated hernia in infants] Vrach. delo, 1931, 14: 1094-7.—Meucci, A. Strangolamcnto intestinale con volvulo in rara forma di ernia interna. Gior med. prat, 1930, 12: 336-10.—Mourgues-Molino.s, E. Ob^ struction intestinale par coudurc persistante de I'.ansc aprea hernie el rangier. Bull. Soc. nat. chir. Par, 1929, 55: 385-7.— Nestor, V, & Mitacu, S. [Case of retrograde strangulated hernia in \V| Spitalul, 1932, 52:451.- Nikitinc, A.N. |Hcrni:d volvulusl Nest, khir, 1926, 7: No. 19, 205- s. -Niosi, G. S. Sopra un caso di stenosi intestinale consccutiva ad ernia strozzata. Policlinico, 1936, 43: sez. chir, 213-31.- Puoa. U. Ernie strozzate ed enterorragre. Ibid, 1934, 41: soz. prut. 907- 72.—Picquct, P, & Bonnecaze, J. Les volvulus herriaires. Arch. mal. app. digest. Par, 1927, 17: 284-03.—Pilven. Les suites d'une hernie e'tranglcie chez une femme agee, ou I amour du travail. Gaz. mid., 1927, 619-21.—Pisani. I, l.e ernio strozzate. Osp. maggiore, Milano, 1931, 22: 341-54.— Ueber, F. Sintomas, diagn6stico y tratamiento de la hernia estrangulada. Progr. clin, Madr, 1920, 16: 330-0.—Rirlic, V, Aussilloux |et al.] Occlusion recidivante par etranglement herniaire totalement inapparent. Arch. Soc. sc. med. biol Montpellier, 1939, 20: 309-13.- Sahasrabudhe, S. V. An unusual case of strangulated hernia. Ind. Af. Gaz, 1934. (>!): 580.—Salaber, J, & KafTaele, A. Sobre un caso de estrcrlicz intestinal consecutiva a una hernia estrangulada y operada Bol. Soc. cir. B. Aires, 1938, 22: 15:;-62.—Santa Maria. TJm caso original de hernia estrangulada. Bol. Seer, saude, liio 1936, 2: No. 5, 123-6.—Schragcr, V. L, & Ragins, A. 11. Strangulated internal hernia simulating appendicitis. Am. .1. Surg, 1935, 29: 300-8.—Sertoli, I, Sullo strozzamento erniario, Boll. Poliamb. Giuseppe Ronzoni, 1935, 9: 377-409. — —■ Su l'ernia interna strozzata delle fossette pericecali. Osp. maggiore, Milano, 1936, 24: 310-6.—Silvestrini, V. Contributo sugli pseudostrozzamenti erniarii. Riforma med, 1927, 43: 418.—Smith, R. E. Torsion of a cyst of a hernial sac, Lancet, Lond, 1940, 1: 221.—Sole, R, & Bueno, R. Infarto o apoplejia del intestino delgado en una hernia estrangulada, curada con adrenalina. Dia med, B. Air, 1939, 11: 82-4.—Sudhues, M. Fehldiagnose Hydrozele des Samenstranges, eingeklemmte Hernie. Kinderarztl. Prax, 1935, 6: 495.—Suren, T. J. J. [Two extraordinary cases of strangulated hernias] Ned. tschr. geneesk, 1940, 84: 1033-7.—Turner, P. Three cases of strangu- lated hernia. Guy's Hosp. Rep, Lond, 1932, 82: 98-105 — Veiga, J. Hernia estrangulada agravada por taxis violento. Impr. med, Rio, 1941, 17: No. 330, 61.—Velasco Blanco, I., & Echegaray, E. M. Un nuevo caso de torcion de los anexos sanos, en un saco herniario. Arch. amer. med, B. Air, 1940, 16: 83-6.—Xavier Lopes, C. Hernias estranguladas. Hora med, Rio, 1939, 3: No. 11, 87-92.—Zironi, M. Sugli esiti lontani delle ernie parietali da pizzicamento; ricerche speri- mentali. Arch. ital. chir, 1939, 57: 260-79.—Zverev, A. I. [Strangulated hernia in children] J. profil. subtrop. klin. med, Tashkent, 1934, 4: 90-100.—Zwaan [Spontaneous perforated strangulated hernia] Geneesk. tschr. Ned. Indie, 1941, 81: 788. ---- strangulated: Treatment. David, A. M. *Urgencia da hcrniotomia e contras da taxis no estrangulamento herniario. 66p. 8? Lisb., 1868. Saxciies de Figueiredo Barreto Perdigao, J. *Enterocele estrangulado; sua diagnose e therapeutica. 63p. 12? Lisb., 1872. Schucht [L. R. H.] A. *Ueber die Behandlung gangranoser Hernien. 37p. 8? Lpz., 1902. Abell, I, jr. The results of taxis in strangulated hernia. Kentucky M. J, 1938, 36: 236-42.—Abraham, P. M. Atropine sulphate in a case of strangulated hernia. Ind. M. Gaz, 1928, 8?i. 27?J-—Ame'ine, A. Contre le taxis. Presse med, 1934, 42: ;,57.—Bagenov, P. S. [Surgical treatment of certain forms of strangulated hernia] Nov. khir, Moskva, 1926, 2: 305-7.- Bordeianu, I. [Taxis-indications and technique] Romftnia med, 1931, 9: 255.—Burkwall, H. F. Strangulated hernia; successful reduction and repair after 13 days. J. Missouri M. Ass, 1942, 39: 132-4.—Casten, D., & Bodenheimer, M. Strangulated hernia reduced en masse. Surgery, 1941, 9: 561-6.— Chavannaz, J. De la reduction en masse des hernies etranglees. Rev. chir. Par, 1927, 65: 791; 1928, 66: 33.— Chutro, P. De tratamiento manual de hernia incarcerada y estrangulada. In his Lecc. clin. quir, B. Air, 1938, 1: 161- <"-!.—Cody, W. E. The treatment of strangulated external hernia. J. Iowa M. Soc, 1936, 26: 283-6.—Curtillet, E. Infarctus intestinal et 6tranglement herniaire; un cas d'en- t6rite aigue extensive mortelle consecutive k la reduction d'un hernie etranglee. Bull. Soc. nat. chir. Par, 1935, 61: 799- 801.—D'Allaines, F. de G. Traitement de quelques hernies Etranglees par la simple kolotomie. Gaz. mid. France, 1929, 3: 073- o. - Das Gupta, S. C. Strangulated hernia (treated by resection and enterorrhaphy) Ind. M. Gaz, 1937, 72: 422 — Del Toro, J. Strangulated hernia; reduction en masse. Bol. As. med. Puerto Rico, 1938, 30: 178-83.—Domenech Alsina. F. Las ventajas de la anestesia raquidea en la estrangulacion HERNIA 613 HERNIA herniaria. Arch, med, Madr, 1928, 28: 645-50—Drucker- man, L. J. Reduction en masse of a strangulated hernia. J. Mount Sinai Hosp. N. York, 1937-38, 4: 457-60.—Dunier, M. V [Complication during reduction of strangulated hernias] Sovet. vrach. J, 1939, 43: 353-6.—Das Gupta, A. K. A remarkable natural cure of strangulated hernia. Ind. M. Gaz, 1938 73: 32.—Gaissinsky, B. E. [Treatment of strangulated hernia] Vest, khir, 1931, 23: 250-65.—Gambari, G. Storia di un ernia strozzata guarita coll'atropa belladonna. Gior. progr. pat, Venez, 1844, ser. 2, 5: 369-83.—Godard, H, & Palios, C. Les hernies etranglees et gangrenes traitSes par l'enterectomie avec suture. Rev. chir. Par, 1929, 67: 476- 501.—Kastner. H. Ueber Fehler und Gefahren bei der un- blutigen Zuriickbringung (Taxis) von Brucheinklemmungen. Med. Klin, Berl, 1939, 35: 1649-51.—Konigsberg, K. J. [Primary resection of the small intestine in strangulated hernia and intestinal obstruction] Khirurgia, Moskva, 1939, No. 8, 98-111.—Lepotitre. Des accidents d'occlusion observes apr& la cure radicale des hernies etrangleos. J. sc. mid. Lille, 1920, 38: 5-9.—Ley, L. Director for strangulated hernia. Brit. M. J, 1937, 1: 125.—Mallet-Guy. Entdrectomie par gangrene d'une anse (Strangle et rdduite par taxis quatre jours aupara- vant, avec refoulement intra-abdominal d'un testicule ectopique, Lyon mdd, 1920, 138: 654-7.—Marcacci, G. Enterotomia per interno strangolamento. Gazz. toscana sc. med. fis, 1849, 7: 153-69.—Mazzini, O. F. Reduccion en masa de una hernia estrangulada. Bol. Soc. cir. B. Aires, 1928, 12: 438-44. Also Sem. mid., B. Air, 1928, 25: pt 2, 877-82.— Meriel & Baillat. A propos de la rachianesthdsie dans l'dtranglement herniaire. Bull. Soc. nat. chir. Par, 1927, 53: 780-2.—Neugebauer, G. Taxis bei Brucheinklemmungen. Med. Klin, Berl, 1926, 22: 885.—Ogilvie, W. H. Treatment of strangulated hernia. Lancet, Lond, 1926, 2: 1126.—Pereyra, E. L. Hernie etranglee rdduite a la suite d'une saignde extremement abondante. J. mid. Bordeaux, 1926, 56: 550.—Pl&cintianu, G. [Is an im- mediate resection of the loop of a strangulated, gangrenous intestine necessary?] Spitalul, 1930, 50: 462.—Power, R. W. Strangulated hernia, its prevention and treatment under local and other anaesthetics. Brit. M. J, 1934, 1: 787-90.—Ralston, G. Strangulated hernia in a pseudo-hermaphrodite; operation; recovery. Ibid, 1927, 1: 463.—Redi, R. La riduzione in massa deU'ernia strozzata. Policlinico, Roma, 1926, 33: sez. prat, 1704.—Reimers, E. K. [Results in treatment of strangulated hernias] Vest, khir, 1938, 56: 596-606.—Santoro, G. Un caso di ernia annessiale strozzata; operazione d'urgenza, guarigione, Atti Soc. ital. ostet, 1913, 18: 307.—Sholkov, B. V. [Opera- tions in strangulated hernia] Nov. khir, Moskva, 1926, 3: 48-54.—Simon, M. M, & Benson, H. A. Strangulated hernia; reduction en masse; review of the literature with report of on unusual case. J. Internat. Coll. Surgeons, 1940, 3: 492-5. Also repr.—Sintomi e cura di malattie mediche e chirurgiche d'urgenza; ernia strozzata. Progr. ter, Milano, 1906, 176-9.— Smith, F. J. Unusually large strangulated abdominal hernia; operation under unfavorable conditions, complete recovery. J. Missouri M. Ass, 1933, 30: 248.—Sokolov, N. V. [Selection of method of operation in strangulated hernia] Kazan, med. J, 1940, 36: 3-7.— Sola Suris, J. Consideraciones sobre el tratamiento de la hernia extrangulada. Rev. cir. Barcelona, 1931, 2: 289-94.—Sosniakov, N. G. [Treatment of strangulated heinia] Nov. khir. arkh, 1939, 44: 136-52.—Souther, C. T. Strangulated hernia with subsequent complications [operation; recovery} J. Med, Cincin, 1926-27, 7: 652.—Wadia, B. K. Ephedrine, and the reduction of a strangulated hernia. Ind. M. Gaz, 1936, 71: 32.—White, W. D. Strangulated hernia reduced en masse. J. Lancet, 1938, 58: 325—Zavaleta, D. E, & Veppo, A. A. La taxis en las hernias estranguladas; indica- ciones, contraindicaciones y peligros. Rev. med, B. Air, 1940, 2: 204-11.—Zikeev, V. V. [Operation for old strangulated hernias] Vrach. gaz, 1930, 34: 1849-52.—Zverev, A. I. [Errors in surgery: Danger in reducing strangulated hernias] Nov. khir. arkh, 1936, 36: 283-5. --- Surgery. Cowell, E. M. Hernia and hernioplasty. 128p. 8? Lond., 1927. Kirschner, M. Die operative Beseitigung der Bauchbruche. p. 1-166. 8? Berl, 1933. In Allg. & spez. chir. Operationslehre (M. Kirschner) Berl, 1933, 5. Bd, 1. T. Noetzel, W. Ueber Hernien-Operationen. 30p. 8? Stuttg., 1937. Ogilvie, W. H. Hernia, p.3597-695. 8: N. Y., 1937. In Postgrad. Surg. (Maingot, R.) N. Y, 1937, 3: 3597-695. Capelle, W. Bruchoperationen. In Fehler chir. Oper. (Stich & Makkas) 2. ed, Jena, 1932, 820-82.—Chauvenet, A. La cure radicale des hernies des vieillards. Monde mid., 1927, 37: 467-9.—Chughtai, M. M. D. A case of self-operation for ventral hernia. Ind. M. Gaz, 1940, 75: 745.— Erdman, S. Hernia; general considerations. In Textb. Surg. (Christopher, F.) 3. ed, Phila, 1942, 1366-8.—Fitzmaurice-Kelly, M. The modern treatment of hernia. Brit. M. J, 1927, 1: 491.— Forgue, E. Ce que la herniologie doit a la chirurgie italienne. Gaz. hop, 1933, 106: 1725-30.------& Aimes, A. Quelques regies essentielles concernant les hernies. In their Les pieges chir. Par 1939, 420-8.—Gosset, A, & Petit-Dutaillis. D. Hernies. In Precis path, chir, 6. ed. Par, 1938, 4: 63-105.— Gussio, S. Chirurgia delle ernie. In Manuale chir. (Alessandri, R.) Roma, 1933, 4: 91-218.—Hancock, J. D. Practical surgical considerations of hernia. Kentucky M. J, 1929, 27: 51-3 — Handley, W. S. The darning of hernias. Brit. M. J, 1941, 1: 943.—Judica, G. L'operabilita delle ernie. Arch, antrop. crim. Tor, 1937, 57: Suppl, 446-9.—Kazda, F. Bruchopera- tion und Bruchdisposition. Wien. med. Wscbr, 1926, 76: 610-4.—Keynes, G. The modern treatment of hernia. Brit. M. J, 1927, 1: 173; 595.—Krabbel. Hernienoperationen im Saughngsalter. Zbl. Chir, 1939, 66: 1737.—Lanzillo, F. Considerazioni anatomo-chirurgiche sulle ernie. Fol. med. Nap, 1938, 24: 678-82.—Lee, W. E, & Downs, T. M. A clinic given at the Pennsylvania Hospital to the post-graduate students in surgery, of the University of Pennsylvania. Surg. Chn. N. America, 1931, 11: 1315-26.—Lembo, S. La vergogna dell'Itaha meridionale; gli erniosi. Chir. ernia, 1931, 13: 69- 92.—Morrison, J. T. The modern treatment of hernia. Brit. M. J, 1927, 1: 353.—Neugebauer, G. Fruhoperation der Hernien. Med. Klin, Berl, 1929, 25: 1132.—Newell, E. T. Hernia in railway surgery. South. M. J, 1932, 25: 745-8.— Quick, B. Hernia and its operative treatment. Australas. N. Zealand J. Surg, 1937-38, 7: 242-55.—Seifert, E. Welche Unterleibsbruche soil man nicht operieren? Miinch. med. Wschr, 1936, 83: 1911-3.—Shands, H. R. Important facts in the operative cure of hernia. N. Orleans M. & S. J, 1926-27, 79: 198-203.—Stoner, A. P. Role of fibrous tissue in hernia repair. Am. J. Surg, 1936, 33: 68-72, 4 pl.—Taylor, W. A. Hernia. Surg. Clin. N. America, 1933, 13: 227-33.—Vail, A. D. Hernia reduced en masse. J. Missouri M. Ass, 1938, 35: 348.— Watson, L. F. Heinia operations in the aged. Am. J. Surg, 1926, n. ser, 1: 271-3. ------ Indications and safeguards for hernia operations in the aged. Internat. Clin, 1932, 42. ser, 2: 118-22, 2 pl.—Wilmoth, C. L. The modern treatment of hernia. Hahneman. Month, 1941, 76: 319-22. ---- Surgery: Accidents, and complications. Natj, E. *Ueber zwei Falle von Cruralislah- mung von Bruchoperation [Bonn] 28p. 8? Trier, 1925. Bauer, O. Einseitige unbeabsichtigte Tubensterilisation bei Herniotomie im Kindesalter. Deut. med. Wschr, 1941, 67: 313-5.—Bergqvist, B. Ueber die Haufigkeit der Thrombo- embolic nach Bruchoperationen. Acta chir. scand, 1938-39, 81: 555-83.—Bruusgaard, C. [Danger of thrombosis, embolism and death following operations for hernia] Norsk, mag. lae- gevid, 1937, 98: [Forh. kir. foren. Oslo] 104-7.—Coffee, H. D. Intestinal obstruction complicating hernia repair. Med. Bull. Veterans Admin, 1934, 10: 249.—Erkes, F. Lebensbedrohliche Nachblutung nach Hernienoperation. Zbl. Chir, 1931, 58: 857-9.—Ermolenko, A. I. [Distant sequels of bladder trauma in hernioplasty] Vest, khir, 1926, 8: No. 22, 129-32.—Fobes, J. H. Case report of hernia and postoperative fistula. In Fifth Ave. Hosp. Clin, N. Y, 1927, 93-9.—Harbitz, H. F. [Thrombo-embolism and mortality rate following operations for hernia] Norsk, mag. laegevid, 1938, 99: 287-309.— Hein-Heifetz, F. B. [Latent infection following herniotomy] Vest, khir, 1938, 55: 284-8—Hermeto, S, jr, & Oliviera Barros, S. Duas complicacoes raras no decurso post-operatorio de uma herniotomia: diltagao gastro-duodenal aguda e f6co de necrose localisado nos musculos largos do abdomen. Ann. paul. med. cir, 1932, 24: 211-31.—Mayo, C. W, & Hardwick, R. S. Unilateral and bilateral hernia; comparative study of postoperative complications and factors concerned. Am. J. Surg, 1936, 32: 4-7.—Meyer, K. A. The incidence of tetanus bacilli in the stools and on the regional skin of 100 urban herniotomy cases. Surg. Gyn. Obst, 1932, 54: 785-89.— Osoling, A. S. Gefahren der Herniotomie. Zbl. Chir, 1926, 53: 3105.—Ranson, F. T. Injuries to femoral vessels during hernia operations. Brit. M. J, 1934, 1: 618.—Rozar, A. R. Pneumoperitoneum following operation for hernia; case report. J. M. Ass. Georgia, 1935, 24: 404-6.—Schafer, A. Ileus nach Karewski'scher Bauchnarbenbruchoperation. Zbl. Chir, 1932, 59: 2466.—Tortora, M. Dalla pratica per la pratica; un caso di enorme sventramento post-operatorio per pregressa erniotomia. Rass. internaz. clin. ter, 1935, 16: 463-5.— Weksner, B. Ueber Blasenverletzungen bei Bruchoperationen. Zbl. Chir, 1927, 54: 143.—Workmen's compensation acts: death due to paralvtic ileus following herniotomy (Wisconsin) J. Am. M. Ass, 1937, 108: 234. ---- Surgery: Anesthesia. Chatain, J. *Le traitement des lesions in- testinales trouvees au cours des interventions pour hernies etranglees. 84p. 24cm. Par., 1938. Abiev, M. B. [Application of extradural segmental anes- thesia in' herniotomy] Khirurgia, Moskva, 1938, No. 9, 65- 70—Domenech Alsina, F. Las ventajas de la anestesia raqufdea en la estrangulacion herniaria. Rev. med. Barcelona, 1929 11- 110-8.—Guedea, L. La anestesia local en la opera- cion'de las hernias. Progr. clin, Madr, 1913, 1: 34-53.—- Hanrahan, E. M, jr. Occasional causes of failure in regional anesthesia for hernia operations. Virginia M. Month, 1926-27, 53: 173-6.—Patterson, D. C. Local anesthesia in hernia work. HERNIA 614 HERNIA Proc. Connecticut MS of hernia work under I Soc., 192S. 10: 158 07. 1926. 134:99-106. Report al anesthesia. Tr. N. England Surg Watson, L. F. Economic advantages of local anesthesia in hernia operations. California West. M, 1934, 41:342. ---- Surgery: Instruments, and sutures. Starkloff, YV. [O. F.] *Das (loepelsche Silberringnetz bei Bauchnarben- und Nabel- briiehen. 22p. 8° Borna, 1934. Bagrov, J. [Homogeneous material for deep sutures in hernioplasty] Vrach. gaz, 1926, 30: 461-3.—Brown. F. R. The use of strips of hernial sac as fascial (living) sutures. Brit, M. .!.. 1930. 1: 858.—Davidson, C. I, Repair of certain type of hernia; hernial sac used as suture material. Am. J. Surg, 1936, 32: 96-9.—Fallon, J. Hernia; attachment of fascial strip to Gallie needle. J. Am. M. Ass, 1939, 113: 1223.—Fobes, J. H. Comparison of ox-fascia and chromic catgut in repair of hernia; 309 case.-. Collect. Papers X York Homeop. M. Coll, 1035, 1: 12S--3L -Goepel. R. Dei Verschluss von Nabel- und Bau.-hu andhernien unter Ver- wendung gegliederter Silberdrahtnctze. Miinch. med. Wschr.. 1928, 75: 127-30. ------ Das gegliederte Silberdraht- beziehungsweise Stahldrahtringnetz bei der Operation von Nabel- und Bauchwandbruchen. Chirurg, 1933, 5: 161 6.— Grausman. R. I. Hernia cord clamp. Am. J. Surg., 1035. 30: 388.—Hawes, G. A. The repair of hernias with ribbon-gut; summary of 20 cases. Ibid.. 1938, 41: 509-11. Haxton, H. A. A new liemia instrument. Brit. M. J, 1941, 1: 88. ■ Kaufman, L. R.. Johnson. W. W, & Lesser, A. A clinical study of alloy steel wire sutures in hernia lepair. Surg. Gyn. Obst, I9.3i), 69: 684-7. Koontz, A. R. Suture material for hernia repair, with special reference to preserved fascia strips. South. M. J, 1932. 25: 372-80.—Masson, J. C. A new instrument for securing fascia lata for repair of hernia. Proc. Mayo Clin, 1933, 8: 529.—Meniri. R. Su di un nuovo istrumento ernio- tomo. Arch. sc. me I. fis. toscane (1837-38) 1840, 1: pt 2, 40-57, pl Parsons, W. B. Silk sutures in the repair of hernia. Ann. Sum., 10.37, 106: 343-7.— Rosenblatt, M. S, & Cooksey, W. IL Mu-clc-fa-cia suture in hernia. Ibid, 1927.86:71-7.— Smiley. K. K. The repair of hernias with fascial sutures. West. I. Suig., 1932, 40: 573-0.—Sofoterov, S. Aponeurosisstreifen als Material fi'n die \aht bei Herniotomie. Zbl. Chir, 1926, 53: 1430-3.- Sweek, W. O. Fascia lata suture in hernia repair. Southwest. M, 1920, 10: 373-8. ---- Surgery: Methods. Adam [A. J.j M. Teber die Radikaloperation der Hernien in den ersten beiden Lcbensjiihren 47p. S? Berl., 1<)3.">. Cardoso. A. C. *Cura radical das hernias 134p. 8? Lisb., 1SSS. Fek<;uso\, A. H. The technic of modern operations for hernia. 366p. 8? Chic., 1907. Sicnorom, B. Sugli esiti e sul inerito della chilissoehisorafia. 46p. 21cm. Milano, 1S3S. Aliteria. Sister M. Draping for hernioi ,,mv Am J \urs 1939, 39: 632.—Andrews, E, & Bump. W. S. Ventral hernia; fascial transplant. Surg. Clin. N. America. 1928, 8: 615-20 — Barnes. W. P. The advantages of the abdominal approach to hernia, \irginia M. Month.. 1939. 66: 895-7.—Barr, E. O. The fascial suture repair in hernia operations. Ibid, 1929-30 56: 328-30.- Bearse. C. Incidental intra-abdominal hernia repair. Am. .1. Sur-.. 1941, 52: 369-71.—Behrend, M. The universal application of fascia in all herniae. Pennsylvania M. ,L. 1930 37. 40: 837-42. Also repr.—Berdichevsky, G. A. [The skin as plastic material for covering large ventral hernias' Nov. khir. arkh.. 1940, 45: 225-9.—Burdick. C. G. Repair of hernia with fascial sutures. N. York Siate I. M , 1928 28- V2m~7t'^ ~,---, , lhe "SP "f livms taM'ial s"tures in the more difficult abdominal hernias. Surg. Chn. N. America 1936. 16: S25-34.—Carson. H. W, & Turner, G. G. Opera- tions for hernia. In Mod. Oper. Surg. (Turner, G. G.) Lond 1934. 2: 1-10. Clarke. R. Further impressions; the Halstead technique. Cuy's Hosp. Gaz, Lond, 1937, 51: 225-9__ Coley, B. L, & Burke, E. The operative treatment of hernia by living sutures. Am. J. Surg, 1927, n. ser, 2: 1-10 pl— Collins. D. C. Abdominal hernias; the use of autogenous- strips of fascia lata in the repair of the more difficult abdominal hernias. California West. M.. 1938, 48: 317-22 Culligan L. C. Direct hernia: combined McArthur white fascia tvoe of' repair. Mime-.c, M., 1937, 20: 475 80.- Dyer R E & larnngton. J. I). Femoral, umbilical, ventral hernia ' In S,„g. le.hn ^I'anipilo. A. V.) 3. ed. Chic, 1938, 133-42 — hgan, M. J. Ox lascia repair in the cure of hernia J M Us Georgia. 1935, 24: 317-21.—Elliott. J. I). The use'of fascia lata in the repair of hernia. Hahneman. Month 19->7 62- 362-9.- Farmer. V. Ventral hernia; a rrew technique" in it- repair. Am. .I. .-org. 1933, 21: 116-9. Also repr. Fieschi. D Plasties en caoutchouc (nuova carrier observes apres ■>- an_ Rev. chir. Par, 1938, 76: l-36.-Flerov, S. A. fAdditional sewing up of muscles to aponeurosis in intrapelvi, h.rnio enterotomyj \ est. khir, 1926, 7: No. 21 49-52 Foster G. V. The use of fascia lata in the repair'of hernia 1 y _ Hiickl, A. [Modification of Koeher'.s radical opciatmn for heinia] Bratisl. lek. listy, 1920-27, 6: 100-3.—Innes. I, W & Ross. J. A. Heinioiomy in old age. Brit. M. .1, I9|(|,'|. 507. Johnson. C. A new and dependable hernioplasl v' Clin. M. A- S.. 1937, 44: 10.—Jolly, K. Hernioplasl ia con H tendon de la fascia lata. Arch. m6d. ferrocar, M6x, 1939 10 1: 229-43.—Jones, W. C. C.vstoeele and rnctocele reniir' J. Florida M. Ass., 1931. 17: 582 ... Knoflach. J. <;',' & Briicke, H. von. Zur Operation von Bauchwandbruchen mittels frei verpflanzter Fascienstreifen ' ^rhnnrplastik) Arch. klin. Chir.. 193.5. 182: II 0. -Koontz. A. R. N,„ prin.-j- ples and procedures in hernia repair. Texas .1 \l 1928- "I 24: 259-65.—Kriukov, M. M. [Method of radical'operation' of ventral hernia and cases of uterine and ovarian hemi-il Vest, khir, 1920, 7: No. 19, 195.—Kulenkampff, 1). /,'„ Technik der Bruchoperationen. Arch. klin. Chir.. 193.', 169: 400-4.—Lake, N. C. Hernia as a surgical emergency Practi- tioner, Lond., 1034, 133: 675 84.—Leischner. H. [Operative treatment of diaphragmatic, paraesophageal, incarcerated hernias] Cas. lek. Cesk., 1933, 72: 1408. MrOehee. J. I,. The use of living fascial transplants in certain types of herniae J. M. Ass. Alabama, 1938 39, 8: 309-1.5.- MrGlannan.'a! Fascial strip transplants in the tieatment of hernia. Am. ,1 Suig.. 1927, n. ser., 2: 532 8. Also repr.—McNealy, R. W'' Are herniorraphiesas successful as they should be'.' .1. Lancet. 1939, 59: 202-4.- McVay. C. B. An anatomic error in current methods of inguinal herniorrhaphy. Ann. Surg, 1911, 113; 1111.—Masson, J. C. The use of living sutures in the repair of abdominal hernias. Minnesota M, 1935, 18: 30.5-9.----- Strips of fascia lata as suture material in the repair of the more difficult abdominal hernias. Virginia M. Month, 1935-36 62: 148-50.—Mayer, G. S. The darning of hernias. Brit M. J, 1941, 2: 170—Mecray, P. M. An operative method of treating hernia m infants. Surg. Clin. N. America, 1926, 6: 1615-7.—Michelson, A. I. [Significance of the modified Barker's modification in Gerald's herniotomy] Sovet. med, 194], 5: 27.—Napalkow, N. Myoplastie dans les diversea formes des hernies. Porto med, 1906, 3: 127.—Niessen, H. Grundsirtzliehes zur Bruchoperafion im Kindesalter Med Welt. 1932, 6: 881-3.—Nuttall, H. C. W. Rectus transplanta- tion in the treatment of ventral herniae. Brit. M. J, 1926, 1: 138. Paterson. J. E. The use of fascial sutures in the operative treatment of li-mia.. Glasgow M. J, 1928, 109: 438-44 - Perpina, S. Unser Verfahren bei den Briiehen des Dickdarms. Zbl. Chir, 1928, 55: 2952-4— Pilcher, R. Repair of hernia with plantaris tendon grafts. Arch. Surg, J939, 38: 10-23.— Polya, E. The principles and the praciice of theradical opera- tions lor hernia. Surgery, 1040, 8: 804-20.—RansohofT, J. I.. The use ol free transplant of fa-cia in the treatment of hernia. J. Med., Cincin., 1934, 15: 90 2. Repair (The) of difficult and recurrent hernias. Practitioner, bond., 1934, 133:754 — keyiakin, S. A. [Post-operative care after henna in small children] Sovet. vrach. gaz, 1934, 38: 1134— Ribera y Sans, J. Nota acerca del tratamiento operatorio de las hernias Congr hisp. portug. cirug, 1898, 1. Congr, 222-0.-Robinson, 8. Hernioplasty; water injection of the sac to facilitate ils removal Surg. Gyn. Obst, 1031, 52: 891. Rutherford. R. Notes on the radical cure of hernia. Med. Press & Circ, Lond, 1933, 136: 411-3.—Sanchis Perpina. V. Nuestro proceder ante las hernias del intestino grueso. Arch, med, Madr, 1928, 29: 233-7 — Santoro, G. Contributo alia cura chirurgica delle ernie addo- minali. Atti Soc. ital. ostet, 1913, 18: 302-0.—Schmieden, V. Die Operationen bei den Unterleibsbriichen. In Chir. Operat. (Bier, Braun, Kiimmel) 1033, 4: 1-93.-Scott, J. F. Fascial transplant in hernia repair. Northwest M, 1942 41: 91 — Smitn, L. Herniotomy by the imbrication method. Bull. (rawtonl Y\ . Long Hosp, 1937, Jan, 15-22.—Staatz, K. S. fascial strips in difficult hernias. Hosp. News, Wash, 1936, 3, 1: 19-23— Stephenson, G. W. Living sutures in repair of ior/V:l,o 'm,,,mn Picture demonstration) Proc. Mavo Clin, ioT, i, 'o Steven9°". D. L. Herniorrhaphy. Brit. M. J, 1.142; 1: 89 Sukhanov, G. A. [Operative treatment of hernias m chilrlren| Sovet. vrach. gaz, 1934, 38: 1118.— lanner, N. C. A slide operation for inguinal and femoral henna Brit. J. Surg, 1941-42, 29: 285-9.— Tenopyr. O, .V Al Akl, K M. Ihe etiologic role of a long omentum and it* proper consideration in attempting to effect a cure of inguinal ami lemoral herniae by operation. Med. Times, N. Y , 1941, r : .2'-,iV^7.'furner' P Hernioplasty. Guv's flo-p. Rep, Lond, 1933, 83: 233-51.- Twyman. E. D, .— Stich, R. Ueber Fehler bei Hernienoperationen. Zbl. Chir, 1926, 53: 884.—Turner, G. G. Physical efficiency after opera- tions for hernia. Lancet, Lond, 1934, 2: 562. ---- Treatment. Armitage, K. Treatment of hernia. Lancet, Lond, 1940, 1: 901.—Barrington-Ward, L. E. The treatment of hernia in children. Practitioner, Lond, 1934, 133: 669-74.—Coley, B. L. The old and the new, in treatment of hernia. Indust. M, 1936, 5: 623-5.—Collins, D. C. Common senss in the treatment of hernia. Med. Rec, N. Y, 1937, 145: 54 — Deaver, J. B. The treatment of hernia. Proc. Interst. I ost- grad. M. Ass. N. America (1930) 1931, 6: 291-5, 6 pl.—G. les- pie, D. H. M. Treatment of hernia. Indust. M, 1939, 8: 336-40.—Innes, L. M. Some out-patient treatments; treat- ment of herniae. Nurs. Times, Lond, 1941, 37: 490.—Keynes, G. The treatment of hernia. Practitioner, Lond, 1934, 133: 657-68.—Mambrini, D. Un migliaio di ernie curate radical- mente nei bambini. Clin, chir, Milano, 1927, 30: 179-90 — Monnier, E. Le traitement des hernies chez 1 enfant. Schweiz. med. Wschr, 1929, 59: 687-9.—Nason, L. H, & Mixter.G G. Hernia reduced en masse. J. Am. M. Ass, 1935, 105: 107o-7.— Rebhorn, E. H. Hernia; end result notes. Bull. Moses Iaylor Hosp, 1928-30, 1: 31-6.—Schneider, H. Ueber die Behand- lung der Untcrleibsbruche. Med. Welt, 1930, 13: 1339-41.— Thomas, T. M. The treatment of hernia in children. Med. Press & Circ, Lond, 1935, 190: 294-8.—Treatment of hernia. Brit. M. J, 1937, 1: 1163. ---- Treatment: Injection. Bratrtjd, A. F. The injection treatment of hernia, p.1-138. 26cm. Bait., 1939. Dernbach, G. P. *The injection treatment of hernia. 21p. Wauwatosa, Wise, 1936. Ferrero, C. S. *Tratamiento medico ambu- latorio de las hernias por medio de las inyeceiones herniales Hcaton. [Univ. Nac. Colombia] 72p. 24^cm. Cucuta, 1937. Goldbacher, L. The injection treatment of hernia and hydrocele. 196p. 23>'2cm. Phila,, 1938 McDonald, G. A. ambulant or injection v. p. 8? Fairfield, 111. Instructions upon the treatment of herniae. 1932. Rice, C. O., & Mattson, H. Injection treat- ment of hernia. 266p. 8? Phila., 1937. Woodall, P. H. Lectures on ambulant proc- tology and the injection treatment of hernia. 125 1. 4?^ Birmingham, Ala., 1932. ---- The injection treatment of hernia. 90p. 8? Birmingham, Ala. [19361 Biederman, M. The injection treatment of hernia. Med. Rec, N. Y, 1937, 145: 239-42. Also N. York Physician, 1940, 14: No. 5, 36-9.—Bowman, F. B. The treatment of hernia by injection. Canad. M. Ass. J, 1937, 36: 276-8.—Brandon, M. A. Injection treatment of hernia. Bull. Off. Pract, 1935-36, 9: 55-8.—Bratrud, A. F. Discussion of Dr Quillin's article; injection treatment of reducible hernia. Internat. J. M. & S, 1934, 47: 398. ------ The ambulant treatment of hernia. Ann. Surg, 1937, 105: 324-38. Also J. Iowa M. Soc, 1935, 25:591-7. Also J. Lancet, 1934, 54: 337-41. Also Minnesota M, 193.5, 18: 441-51. Also repr.—Burcick, C. G, & Coley, B. L. Injection method of treating hernia. Ann. Surg, 1937, 106: 322-33.—Butler, P. T. The injection treatment of hsrnia. Med. World, 1936, 54: 567-70. Also Am. J. Surg, 1937, 37: 250-02.—Callaway, E. Injection treatment of hernia. J. M. Ass. Georgia, 1938, 27: 139-42.—Campos & Subinchs. Trata- miento de las hernias por el m§todo fibros'inico. Inform, mid., Valladolid, 1929, 6: 155; 185.—Chavez, I. Tratamiento de las hernias por inyeceiones. Rev. mex. cir. gin. cancer, 1937, 5: 79-99.—Cobb, S. A. Some aspects of the injection treatment of hernia. Maine M. J, 1937, 28: 131-3.—Coley, B. L. In- jection treatment of hernia. N. York State J. M, 1937, 37: 1726-30.—Cornell, J. H. Injection treatment of hernia. Nat. Eclect. M. Ass. Q, 1940-41, 32: 19.—Crohn, N. N. The in- jection treatment of hernia. J. Am. M. Ass, 1937, 108: 540-4. Also repr.—Diamant-Berger, L. Le traitement des hernies par les injections sclerosantes. Bull, mid. Par, 1939, 53: 202-5.—Dick, B. Injection treatment of hernia. Tr. Med. Chir. Soc. Edinburgh, 1938-39, Session 118, 145.—Downing, E. M. Injection treatment of hernia. BuU. Off. Pract, 1935-36, 9: 36; 41.—Dowson, A. W. The injection treatment of hernia. Clin. M. & S, 1937, 44: 210-2.—Fiedler, F. W. The injection treatment of hernia. Memphis M. J, 1939, 14: 206 —Fiske, F. A. The injection treatment of hernia. In Cyclop. Med. (Piersol-Bortz) Phila, 1938, serv. vol, 789-94.— Foley, W. K. The injection treatment for hernia. Osteopath. Phys. Ther, 1933. 3: 65-83.—Fowler, S. W. Injection method in treatment of hernia. J. Am. M. Ass, 1937, 108: 1668; 1938 110- 2099. ------ The hernia injectors: the middle period. Med. Rec, N. Y, 1938, 147: 363-8.—Girard, F. R. Treatment of hernia by the injection method. California West. M, 1936, 45: 385-91.—Gray, St. G. B. D. Injection treatment of reducible hernia. Proc. R. Soc. M, Lond, 1934, 27: 1289-91. ------ Injection treatment of hernia. Lancet, Lond 1936, 2: 1301. Also In Postgrad. Surg. (Maingot, R.) N. Y, 1936, 2: 3245-62.—Harris, F. I, & White, A. S. The injection treatment of hernia. Surg. Gyn. Obst, 1936, 63: 201-11—Higinbotham, N. L. The injection treatment of hernia. J. Tennessee M. Ass, 1037, 30: 385-90.—Injection treatment of hernia. J. Am. M. Ass, 1936, 103: 10o3 — Jackson A. S. The treatment of hernia by the injection method. Rocky Mountain M. J, 1938, 35: 980-3. Also repr.— Johnston, C. H. Injection treatment of hernia. J. Iowa M. Soc, 1930, 26: 556-61.—Jolly, E. Tratamiento de las hernias inducibles' con las inyeceiones esclerosantes. Cir. cirujan, Mex 1937 5" 483-500. ------ Tratamiento ambulatorio de las hernias. Rev. med, Puebla, 1939, 12: No. 109, 16-24. Also Arch. med. ferrocar, Mex, 1939-40 1: 51-7 .-Kelly, FA. Injection treatment of hernia. Indust. M, 1030, 5: o22. Also J Michigan M. Soc, 1938, 37: 1095-8.—Knudson, A. H. The ambulant treatment of hernia. Wisconsin M. J, 1936 35- 627-9—Kretzschmar. K. E. The injection treatment of hernia. CUn. M. & S, 1935, 42: 371-5.—Lahvis. P. The injection treatment of hernia; its scope and hmitation. Chn. Med 1940 47: 379-81. Also Indust. M, 1941, 10: 44.— La Rochelle F. D. Treatment of hernia with special reference to the injection method. Am. J. Surg, 1932 n. ser , 16: 501-3. Also repr. Also Med. J & Rec, 1932 136: 184. Also Bull. Off. Pract, 1933, 7: 82-4.-Larson, I, M. The injection or nonoperative treatment of hernia. Minnesota M 1Q"U 17- 703-11 —Lee, M. Injection treatment ot hernia. Practitioner Cd, 1938, 140: 93-9.-McCastor J. T. N & McCastor, M. C. Injection method for the treatment o hernia; preliminary report. Virginia M Month, 1938, 65: 744_7__McDaniel, R. C. Eradication of hernia by injection. Northwest M, 1936, 35: 23-6-McMillan W' M. Injection treatment of hernia. Illinois M, J, 1936, 70: 264-71, ------ HERNIA 616 HERNIA & Cunningham, D. R. The injection treatment of reducible hernia. J. Am. M. Ass, 1936, 107: 1791 .5— Marcucci. G. La cura deU'ernia con iniezioni sclerosanti. Arch. ital. chir., 1939, 56: 339-60. -Marin Kspinosa, J. Tratamiento de las hernias por inyeceiones. Med. ibera, 1932, 26: 791-4. Also Siglo med, 1932, 89: 40.5-7.—Mayer. I. The treatment of hernia bv subcutaneous injection; historical review and de- scription'of author's method. Med. .1. & Rec, 1927, 125: 528 596; 072; 1928, 128: 415— Pancaro, L. Sulla cura ambu- lato'ria delle ernie. Rinasc. med, 1939, 16: 231.—Patterson, D. C. Injection treatment of hernia. J. Connecticut. M. Soc, 1936-37, 1: 25.5-62. Also Tr. N. England Sum. Soc, 1939, 22: 278-85— Pollaczek, K. F. Zur ambtilatorischen Durch- fuhrung von Operationen bei Kindern; insbesondere von Kinderhernien. Wien. med. Wschr, 1935, 8.5: 819 21. - Porritt, A. E. The injection treatment of heinia. Proc. IL Soc. M, Lond, 1938-39, 32: sect, surg, 893-5- Quillin, I, J. The injection treatment of reducible hernia. Internat. J. M. & S, 1934, 47: 394-7.—Rice, C. O. Hernia; its cure by the injection of irritating solutions. J. Iowa M. Soc, 1936, 26: 279-83.—Riddle, P. The injection treatment of hernia. Texas J. M, 1936-37, 32: 226-30.—Romualdi, P. La cura delle ernie per mezzo delle iniezioni sclerosanti. Ann. igiene, 1937, 47: attual, 169-77.—Rosen, R. The injection method in the treatment of hernia. Med. Rec, N. Y, 1936, 143: 115-7.—Roux, J. Cure des hernies par la methode des injec- tions en Amerique. Praxis, Bern, 1938, 27: 213.—Schoolcraft, C. E. The injection treatment of hernia. Tr. Am. Coll. Proct, 1931, 8: 279-316, port.—Schwindt, L. W. The treat- ment of hernia by ambulant methods. J. Med. Pract, 1936, 1: 24.—Seale, H. The injection treatment of hernia. Texas J. M , 1937-38, 33: 299-301.—Shields, C. L. Injection treat- ment of hernia. Rocky Mountain M. J, 1942, 39: 109-11 — Simms, J. R, jr. The injection treatment of hernia. Missis- sippi Doctor, 1938-39, No. 11, 13-6.—Slobe, F. W. The injection treatment of hernia. Indust. M, 1935, 4: 226; 1936, 5: 201; 1941, 10: 145. ------ The ambulant treatment of reducible hernia. Surg. Clin. N. America, 1937, 17: 513-21.— Steenkamp, W. P, jr. The injection treatment of hernia. S. Afr. M. J, 1938, 12: 919-21.—Tratamiento de las hernias con inyeceiones. Bol. Of. san. panamer, 1941, 20: 76—8.— Veasey, B. R. Injection treatment for the cure of hernia. Delaware M. J, 1939, 11: 7.—Ward, C. E. The ambulant treatment of hernia. Clin. M. & S, 1936, 43: 503-0.—Weber, A. J. Injection method of treatment for hernia. J. Kansas M. Soc, 1936, 37: 485-8.—Wernicke, H. O. The injection treat- ment of hernia. Surg. Gyn. Obst, 1939, 68: 1093-8.—Whit- ham, R. H. The injection treatment of hernia. Nebraska M. J, 1937, 22: 257-60.—Wollermann. Die Timmermannsche Injektionsmethode in den letzten 2.5 Jahren. Aerztl. Rdsch, 1929, 39: 283. ---- Treatment: Injection: Complications. Berne, C. J. Fatalities following injection treatment of hernia. J. Am. M. Ass, 1938, 110: 1812.—Biederman, M. Pitfalls in the injection treatment of hernia and how to avoid them. Med. Rec, N. Y, 1937, 146: 253.—Cranmer, R. R. Report of a case of mesenteric thrombosis resulting from injec- tion treatment of hernia. J. Lancet, 1935, 55: 687.—Gold- hahn, R. Einspritzungsbehandlung von Briichen und Fort- pflanzungsfahigkeit. Munch, med. Wschr, 1938, 85: 1475, ------ Ueber schwere Schadigungen nach Bruchbehandlung mittels Alkoholinjektionen. Khn. Wschr, 1930, 9: 1447; 1968.—Harris, F. I, & White, A. S. Injection treatment of hernia: a critical analysis of the failures, recurrences and com- plications. Am. J. Surg, 1937, 37: 263-71 Jacobi, H. Schwere Schadigung nach Bruchbehandlung mittels Alkohol- injektion. Khn. Wschr, 1931, 10: 71 [Erwiderung von R. Goldhahn] 72.—Kefalas, A. An unusual development in a case of hernia treated by injection. Practitioner, Lond, 1941, 146: 404.—McDonough, E. F. A complication of injection treat- ment of hernia. N. England J. M, 1937, 217: 402.—Rea, C. E. Sterilitv following the injection treatment of hernia. Ann. Surg, 1937, 105: 351-3.—Rice, C. O, & Larson, L. M. Com- plications and end results associated with the injection treat- ment for hernia. South. Surgeon, 1936, 5: 390—400.—Zieman, S. A, & Larkowski, T. M. Necrosis of cord structures following the injection treatment of reducible hernia. J. Am. M. Ass, 1936, 107: 1558. ---- Treatment: Injection: Results. Fulton, J. \Y. *The injection treatment of hernia; a study of 54 cases. 26p. 4? Wauwa- tosa, Wise, 1938. Bratrud, A. F. The ambulant treatment of hernia; opinions and impressions, with results to date, gained from practical and experimental experience. Indust. M, 1935, 4: 469-74.— Carbo, R. J. The injection treatment of hernia; results in 239 cases. Med. Ann. District of Columbia, 1939, 8: 10-2. Also repr.—Dobson, L. The late results of the injection treatment of hernia. Surgery, 1940, 7: 836-47.—Earl, G. Comparative values of injection and surgical treatment of hernia. Minne- sota M, 1938, 21: 250-4.—Fowler. S. W. Experience with the injection treatment of hernia. Med. Rec, N. Y, 1935, 141: 207-9. Also repr. ------ The injection treatment of hernia; the current objections. Indust. M., 1936, 5: 405-10. —---■ The status of research on the injection treatment of hernia. Am. J. Sum, 1937. 37: 403-12. -Gallagher. K. J. Hernia, injection or operation'.' Minnesota M, 1937, 20: 589-92.— Gordon, G., & Gordon, E. Hernioplasty in patients previously treated by the injection method. J. Am. M. Ass, 1936, 107: 1110-2.—Hall. J. S. K. The eradication of hernia by injec- tions; experiments and clinical investigations with the method originated bv Dr E. Pifia Mestre, of Barcelona; preliminary report. Med. J. & Rec, 1929, 130: 61-3.—Harris, F. I, & White, A. S. Injection treatment of hernia: its experimental basis. California West. M, 1936, 45: 382 5. ------ Injec- tion treatment of hernia: its present-day status. Ibid, 391- 402.------ Evaluation of Ihe injection treatment of hernia; a statistical and analytic studv; clinical lecture at San Francisco session. J. Am. M. Ass.. 1938, 111: 2009-13.—Jackson. A. S. The injection treatment of hernia based on a studv of 528 case*. J. Kansas M. Soc, 1939, 40: 405-8.—Jameson, F. S. Treat- ment of hernia by injection; ambulatory and non-oporativo relief fol lowing the method of Pifia Mestre. Clin. M.&S, 1031, 38: 172-5. ------& Cantala, J. The relief of inguinal hernia without operation; successful use of Pifia Mestre's method of subcutaneous injection in a series of 64 cases. Med. J. & Rec, 1930, 131: 87-90.—Kelly, F. A. Injection treatment of hernia; some experimental work. Grace Hosp. Bull, Detr, 1937, 21: 9-15.—Koontz, A. R. Experiences with the injection treat- ment of hernia. South. M. J, 1941, 34: 297-302.—Levi. P. The present status of the ambulant treatment of hernia. Clin. M. & S, 1936, 43: 126-9.—Lippman, I. W. Injection treat- ment of hernia; the present status of injection hernioplasty. Med. Rec, N. Y.. 1937, 146 403-8.—McMillan, W. M. The injection treatment of hernia; an evaluation based on 5 years' experience. Indust. M, 1939. 8: 30-9.—Man, A. E. Present status of the injection treatment of hernia. Am. Med, 1936, 42: 477-81.—Mancil, L. Evaluation of the injection treatment of hernia in older patients; a 3 year statistical analysis. Arch. Surg, 1940, 41: 114-22.—Mayer I. Hernia treated by sub- cutaneous injections; report of 30 years' experience with 15 illustrative case reports. Med. J. & Rec, 1930, 131: 90-2. Also repr.------The corrective treatment of hernia; observa- tions from 30 years of experience in the injection method. Ibid, 1932, 125: 275-8. Also repr.—Mysh. V. [Review of literature on injection treatment of hernia] Khirurgia, Moskva, 1938, 96-105.—Palmer, R. F. Experience with the injection treatment of hernia. Southwest M, 1937, 21: 80-8. -Present status of injection treatment of hernia. J. Am. M. Ass., 1940, 115: 533.—Prioleau, W. H. The late results of the injection treatment of hernia. J. S. Carolina M. Ass, 1940, 36: 255 — Quillin, L. J. Two years' experience with the injection treat ment of hernia. Yearb. N. York N. England Ass. Railw. Surg. 1935, 45: 44-53.—Rice, C. O. The injection treatment of hernia; an evaluation of the technic and results. Ann. Surg, 1937,105:343-51. —----Complications associated with the treatment of hernia; injection versus operative treatment. Minnesota M, 1941, 24: 206. ------& Larson, I, M. The fate of the hernial sac in hernia treated by the injection method. West. J. Surg, 1930, 44: 428.—Slater, R. Inadequacy of injec- tion treatment of herniss. N. England J. M, 1939, 221: 895 — Slobe, F. W. Injection versus surgery in the cure of hernia; a critical summary. Am. J. Surg, 1938, 42: 704-13.—Tornel y Garros, L. G. Critica del tratamiento no operatorio de las hernias por las inyeceiones proliferantes. Ars med, Barcel, 1930, 6: 178-80.—Wangensteen, O. H. The status of the injection treatment of hernia. Ann. Surg, 1937, 105: 322-4.— Warfield, J. O. A comparison of the injection and operative treatments of hernia. Med. Ann. District of Columbia, 1938, 7: 96-9.—Winters, R. A. R63um6 and classification of the injection treatment of hernia. Med. Rec, N. Y, 1936, 144: 114-6. ---- Treatment: Injection: Technic. Biegeleisen, H. I. Two fatty acid solutions for the injection tieatment of hernia. Am. J. Surg, 1937, 37: 413-7.—Fowler, S. W. The technic of the hernial injection treatment. Med. Rec, N. Y, 1935, 141: 387-90. Also repr—Hanisch, L. E. . Further standardization after experience with the injection treatment of hernia. Nebraska M. .1, 1938, 23: 413-5.— Harris, F. I, White, A. S, & Biskind, G. R. Observations on solutions used for injection treatment of hernia. Am. J. Surg, 1938, 39: 112-9.—Jimenez, M. Protein therapy and calcium therapy in the injection treatment of hernia. Med. Rec, N. Y, 1939, 150: 384-6.—Lee, M. Solutions used in the injection treatment of hernia. Practitioner, Lond, 1939, 142: 221-3.— Levy, I, H. A new hernia injection solution; with the use ol vitamin ('. Med. Rec, N. Y, 1942, 155: 65.—Manoil, L. Histologic effects of various sclerosing solutions uoed in the injection treatment of hernia. Arch. Surg, 1938, 36: 171-89. 5 pl.- Rice, C. O. The rationale of the injection treatment of hernia. Minnesota M, 1935, 18: 623-7. Also repr.-----& Larson, L. M. Technic for the injection treatment of hernia. South. Surgeon, 1936, 5: 227-33.—Rice, C. O, & Mattson, H. Histologic changes in the tissues of man and animals following the injection of irritating solutions intended for the cure of hernia. Illinois M. J, 1936, 70: 271-8.—Wyss, F. Die Be- handlung der Hernien mit Alkoholinjektionen. Schweiz. med. Wschr, 1929, 59:85-9. HERNIA 617 HERNIA ---- Treatment: Methods. Helm, G. [K.] *Die operationslose Bruch- behandlung [Munchen] 32p. 21cm. Bleiche- rode, 1938. Meyer-Grell, H. Bruchleiden, ihre natur- gerechte orthopadische Behandlung, allgemein- verstandlich dargestellt. 39p. 23^cm. Lpz., 1939. Bigilman, L. Nonsurgical treatment of hernia. Med. Rec, N. Y, 1935, 142: 191-3.—Cowell, E. The modern treatment of hernia. Clin. J, Lond, 1930, 59: 415-9.—David, K. Die orthopadische Bruchbehandlung, ihre Bedeutung, ihr Wesen, ihre Ergebnisse. Ther. Gegenwart, 1931, 72: 353-9.—Gerald's (The) balm fraud; a rupture cure swindle debarred from the mails. J. Am. M. Ass, 1938, 110: 1208.—Jaeger, F. Ueber operationslose Bruchbehandlung. Arch. klin. Chir, 1937, 190: 198-218.—Plapao Laboratories, Inc.; E. J. Stuart and his quack rupture-cure device debarred from the mails. J. Am. M. Ass, 1936, 106: 557. --- Treatment: Supports. Cluthe, C. Cluthe's advice to the ruptured. 76. ed. 90p. 8? Bloomfield, N. J., 1935.' Michael, B. F. Not one person in 5,000 knows what is in this book! [hernia] 28p. 8? [Binghamton, N. Y., 1935] Austin, A. L. Abdominal and rupture support. U. S. Patent Off, 1941, No. 2,230,636.—Coyte, R. Trusses and belts. Brit. M. J, 1938, 2: 1322-4.—Eccles, W. McA. The modern treatment of hernia by trusses. Ibid, 1928, 2: 144.— Foster, J. S. Rupture truss. U. S. Patent Off, 1940, No. 2,226,509.—Grant, C. Hernia pad for abdominal supporting garments. Ibid, 1941, No. 2,232,381.—Hamann, F. A. Elastic pad for springless hernia bandages. Ibid, 1937, No. 2,070,727.—Hanson, F. O. Hernia appliance. Ibid, 1939, No. 2,170,558.—Homan, J. G. Rupture supporting device. Ibid, 1936, No. 2,063,382.—Laub, S. V. Hernia appliance or the like. Ibid, 1940, No. 2,223,006.—Laumonier & Leger. Contusion de l'abdomen par bandage herniaire; perforation du grele. J. mid. Bordeaux, 1939, 116: 357.—Le Cras, T. J. Hernia truss. U. S. Patent Off, 1935, No. 1,989,936.—Moore, F. E. Hernia pad. Ibid, 1939, No. 2,172,621.—Rowley, W. S. Medical truss and method of making same. Ibid, 1935, No. 1,992,397.—Schanz, A. Ueber Bruchbander und Leibbinden. Chirurg, 1928-29, 1: 594-601.—Schoeben, H. J. Rupture appliance. U. S. Patent Off, 1939, No. 2,182,264.—Stoccada, F. Una proposta per onorare il Maestro (sopprimere l'abuso del cinto) Arch. Soc. ital. chir (1937) 1938, 44: 1069. --- ventral. Campbell, E. G. Spontaneous ventral hernia; X-ray find- ings simulating carcinoma of cecum; case report. Memphis M. J, 1927, 4: 80.—Coley, B. L. Ventral hernia. In Cyclop. Med. (Piersol-Bortz) Phila, 1939, 7: 260.—Habbe, J. E. X-ray findings in a large ventral hernia. Radiology, 1926, 7: 511.—Jennings, J. E. Ventral hernia. Surg. Clin. N. America, 1927, 7: 909-24—Manjos, P, & Coley, B. L. Acquired inter- fascial bursa complicating Wangensteen repair for ventral hernia. Am. J. Surg, 1939, 44: 441.—Shelley, H. J. Ventral hernias; a study of 550 hernias and 458 repairs. South. Sur- geon, 1940, 9: 617-56.—Synek, J. [Hernia of Gimbernat's ligament] Cas. lek. cesk, 1933, 72: 1594. --- ventral lateral [Linea semilunaris Spi- gelii] Brtjnner, E. *Beitrag zur Kasuistik der Hernia ventralis lateralis. 24p. 8? Ziir., 1935. Dorfler, J. *Die Bedeutung der Hernia lineae semilunaris Spigelii fiir die Lehre von der Entstehung der Hernien [Berlin] 35p. 8? [Berl.] 1926. Lupu, J. Contribution a l'etude des hernies ventrales laterales spontanees, dites de la ligne semilunaire de Spigel. 51p. 8? Par., 1937. Pabst, M. *Ueber die Hernia semilunaris Spigelii. 12p. 8? Halle, 1925. Zurn, W. *Betrachtungen iiber die Hernia lineae semilunaris Spigelii [Munster] 15p. 22cm. Diisseld., 1935. Angeletti, E. L'ernia spontanea della linea semilunare di Spigelio. Arch. ital. chir, 1927, 17: 38-60—Anzilotti, G. Contributo alio studio delle ernie ventrali laterali o della cosi- detta linea di Spigel. Ibid, 1938, 50: 107-19.—Arcieri. G. Contributo alio studio ed alia cura deU'ernia semilunare di Spigelio, spontanea. CUn. chir, Milano, 1938, 41: 125-40 — Brandtner, C. E. Ueber einen Fall von traumatischer Bauch- deckenhernie in der Linea Spigelii. Arch, orthop. UnfaUchir, 1933, 33: 219-21.—Costa, G. L'ernia spontanea della linea semilunare di Spigelio. Arch. ital. chir, 1933, 34: 705-46 — 7nnTH?« ■ ,C°ntribution & l'etude de la hernie dite de'la zone de Spigel. Bruxelles mid., 1037-38, 18: 851-3—Dick E Spigelian hernia. Gy6gyaszat, 1930, 70: 675-7.—Duke L* s' K^oge Jf:terLal ventral hernia. Med. J. Australia, 1928' l: 583 —Eliashovich, L. I. [Rehn's operation; cutaneous graft (cutis-subcutis) in an extensive hernia through the line of Spigel] Vest, khir 1932, 26: 176.-Fournier. R. Hernie de la hgne de Spigel. Bull. Soc. obst. gyn. Paris, 1933, 22: 695- 7.—Junet, W. Hernie de la hgne semi-lunaire de Spigel. Helvet. med. acta, 1937, 4: 403-6.—Leoni lparraguirre, C. A Hernias de la hnea de Spigel; su tratamiento quirurgico Rev cir, B. Air, 1938, 17: 483-500.—Lobello. F. Contributo alia conoscenza dell ernia spontanea della linea di Spigel. Riforma med, 1934, 50: 525-9.—McGlannan, A. Lateral ventral hernia Tr. South. Surg. Ass. (1926) 1927, 39: 162-7 Also repr. Also Ann. Surg, 1927, 85: 284-7. Also repr.—Massa- buau, Guibal, A, & Cabanac. Deux cas de hernies ventrales laterales spontanees Etranglees (hernies dites de la hgne de Spigel) presence du diverticule de Meckel dans une de ces hernies. Arch. Soc. sc. med. biol. Montpellier, 1933, 14: 340- 50.—Mazzini, O. F. Hernias de la linea semilunar de Spigel Sem. mid., B. Air, 1926, 33: 1334-9.—Meyer, P. Zur Lehre von der Hernia lineae semilunaris Spigelii. Zbl. Chir 1926 53: 1949-51 —Meyer-Wildisen, R. Ueber seitliche Bauch- bruche. Ibid, 1936, 63: 793-5.—Odes, L. A. [Hernias of the spigelian Une] Vest, khir, 1936, 44: 49-52.—Orator, V. Zur KUmk der seitlichen Bauchbruche. Deut. Zschr. Chir, 1932, 237: 524-8.—Pampari, D. Su di un caso di ernia ventrale multipla (ernia dello Spigelio) e di concomitante ernia ombelicale strozzata. Arch. ital. chir, 1934, 37: 619-34.—Papin, F. Hernie etranglee de la Ugne semi-lunaire de Spigel. Bordeaux chir, 1936, 7: 203.—Pozzi, G. L'ernia della linea semilunare di SpigeUo. Boll. spec. med. chir, 1931, 5: 267-91.—Reeke, T. Ein Beitrag zur Klinik der seitlichen Bauchbruche. Deut. Zschr. Chir, 1933, 241: 126.—Roden, G. [Cases of Spigelian hernia] Hygiea, Stockh, 1930, 92: 861.—Sarot, I. A. Hernia in the hnea semilunaris. J. Mount Sinai Hosp. N. York, 1941- 42, 8: 164-6.—Scopinaro, A. J. Hernia de la linea semilunar de Spigel en un recien nacido. Sem. med, B. Air, 1935, 42: 284-9.—Traissac, R. Sur un cas de hernie etranglee de la hgne de Spigel. Bordeaux chir, 1937, 8: 115-20. ---- ventral median [Linea alba] Rodriguez, J. A. *Les hernies occultes de la ligne blanche de 1'ombilic et leurs consequences cliniques; les syndromes gastro-intestinaux aigus et chroniques dus aux hernies de la ligne meMiane de l'abdomen. 96p. 8? Par., 1929. Aminev, L. M. [Hernias of the navel and linea alba] Sovet. khir, 1931, 1: 457.—Bass, M. M. [Incarcerated hernia of the linea alba] Vest, khir, 1936, 44: 64-6. Also Zbl. Chir, 1936, 63: 316-20.—Brandt, G. Zur Operation grosser Bauchnarben- briiche der Linea alba. Zbl. Chir, 1931. 58: 2307-9.—Charlton, H. R. Congenital hernia at the linea alba. Am. J. Obst, 1926, 11: 103-5 [Discussion] 120.—Clemente, D. Plastica a lembi dell'aponevrosi in un caso di laparocele della linea mediana. Policlinico, 1930, 37: sez. prat, 173.—Del Valle, D. Una t6cnica para el tratamiento de las eventraciones de la linea blanca. Sem. med, B. Air, 1934, 41: 1586-8.—Eschenko, I. N. [Method of operation in case of separation of abdominal muscles in herniae of linea alba] Vrach. delo, 1927, 10: 441.—Fromme, A. Ueber die Operation grosser Bauchnarbenbriiche in der Mittellinie, besonders oberhalb des Nabels. Beitr. klin. Chir, 1926, 137: 690-700.—Gutmann, P. Ein Fall von Inkarzeration der Hernia lineae albae. Zbl. Chir, 1926, 53: 2461.—Lastra, J. S. Hernia estrangulada de la linea alba. Vida nueva, Habana, 1928, 22: 376-8.—Mahorner, H. Umbilical and midline ventral herniae. Tr. South. Surg. Ass. (1939) 1940, 52: 313-31.—Marcus, M. Zur Operation grosser Bauchnarben- briiche der Linea alba. Zbl. Chir, 1932, 59: 201-3.—Naegeli, T. Die Hernie der Linea alba. Med. Klin, Berl, 1939, 35: 1425.—Pismarev, M. M. [Differential diagnosis and elimina- tion of pain in hernias of the linea alba, and tendinous fascia] Sovet. vrach. J, 1936, 1: 660-5.—Popper, H. L. Zur Frage der eingeklemmten Briiche der Linea alba. Zbl. Chir, 1936, 63: 1397.—Power, R. W. The treatment of mid-line ventral hernia. Brit. M. J, 1937, 1: 958-60.—Rocher, H. L. La plastie de fascia lata dans les eventrations congenitales (de- hiscence de la ligne blanche) P. verb. Congr. fr. chir, 1934, 43: 353-6. Also Bordeaux chir, 1935, 6: 60.—Svet, N. M. [Stran- gulated hernias of the linea alba of the abdomen] Vest, khir., 1941, 61: 42-6.—Teplitzky, G. B. [Hernia of the Unea alba Klin, med, Moskva, 1928, 6: 651-0. voluminous. Jablonski, W. *Ueber die Fettgewebsexzision (Adiposektomie) und^Metallnetzimplantation bei der Operation grosser und tibergrosser Hernien der Bauchwand [Basel] 29p. 8? Riga, 1936. Allende, C. I. Gran eventraci6n inguinoabdominal-externo- costopubiana inferior derecha; cura radical por injerto de fascia lata. Bol. Soc. cir. B. Aires, 1937, 21: 671-4.—Beer, E. Operation for large ventral hernia. Ann. Surg, 1931, 94: 117- 43.—Bertelsmann, R. Zur Naht grosserer Bauchbruche. Zbl. HERNIA 61S HERNIA Chir, 1934. 61: 1864.—Bile, S. Voluminosa ernia della parete anteriore dell'addome, con aderenze totali endosacculari, contenente intero, il sigma colico; guaragione. Policlinico, 1939. 46: sez. prat, 331-3.—Brau-Tapie. Deux cas de hernies monstrueuses; cure radicale; gudrison se maintcnant complete 6 et 10 ans apr^s. Bordeaux chir, 1936, 7: 73 S—Collins, D. C. Huge ventral hernia complicated by incarceration of gangrenous ileum; case report. Am. J. Surg, 193C, 34: 107-9. Dcmmer, F. Deckung komphzierter oder besonders grosser Ventral- hernien. Wien. khn. Wschr, 1929, 42: 772-5.—Gallie, W. E. Closing very large hernial openings. Tr. Am. Surg. Ass, 1932, 50: 71-4. Also Ann. Surg, 1932, 96: 551.—Jorge, J. M, & Berisso, O. A. Indicaciones y ventains de la fr6nico-estrangu- lacion en el tratamiento de las grandes eventraciones. Bol. Soc. cir. B. Aires, 1939, 23: 907-18.—Koch, J. Zur Frage der freien autoplastischen Faseicntransphuitation bei grossen Bauchdeckenbruchen. Zbl. Chir, 1020, 53: 2850-2.—Krauss, F. Bauchvolumenvergrosserung durch Phrenicusvereisung als vorbereitende Operation bei grossen Bauchbruch- und Nabel- bruchopcrationen. Ibid, 1929, 56: 984.—Llusema Uranga, E. Hernias y terrenos de deficit; consideraciones sobre un primer caso de frenicectomfa en el tratamiento de las hernias gisrantes. Rev. cir. Barcelona, 1932, 3: 272-0—Makel, H. P. Case report; massive ventral hernia. Mil. Surgeon, 1929, 65: 63.— Mallebrein, O. Ein Fall von Gastro-Thorakoschisis. Zbl. Gyn., 1929, 53: 944-8.—Meyer, A. W, & Baatz. H. Operation grosser Bauchnarbcnbi iiche. Beitr. klin. Chir., 1934, 169: 612-9.—Nava y Rojas. R. Cirurgia de las eventraciones. Rev. cienc. med, Mex, 1929, 8: 209-78.—Naveiro. R. Complica- ciones graves de las eventraciones. An. Inst. clin. med, B. Air, 1935, 16: 559-62.—Oliveira, E. de. Sobre um caso de eventracao. Rev. med. mil, Rio, 1936, 25: 319-24—Pels- Luesden. Eine einfache Art, grosse Bauchbruche zu beseitigen. Wien. med. Wschr, 1929, 79: 619-21.—Ritter, C. Zur Technik der Operation tibergrosser Bauchbruche. Deut. Zschr. Chir, 1930, 225: 450-5.—Salzer. Die Bcliandlung grosser Bauch- wandbriiche. Wien. med. Wschr, I 010, 90: 883.—Schlesinger, A. Die Operation tibergrosser Bauchnnrboiibriiche. Zbl. Chir, 1932, 59: 1151-5.—Sica, L. S. A record-breaking hernia. J. M. Soc. N. Jersey, 1938, 35: 720 2. Thorek, M. The radical treatment of voluminous herniae. Clin. M. & S, 1927, 34: 591-5. ------ The occurrence of voluminous hernia? and their management; with a review of the Uterature. Med. J. Rec, 1930, 131: 83-6. Also repr. Tiegel, M. Die Operation grosser Bauchnarbenbriiche mit meiner Schraubplattennaht. Zbl. Chir, 1932, 59: 716-9.—Voelcker, F. Geleitwort zu der nachfnlgenden Meverschen Arbeit. Beitr. klin. Chir, 1934, 160: 010. ----in animals. Katjfhold, J. *Ueber einen Fall von Ver- knocherung der Hernienkapsel eines Bauch- bruches beim Rinde mit besonderer Beriick- sichtigung der P>age der Metaplasie des Binde- gewebes in Knochengewebe. 327. HERNQVIST, Peter, 1726-1808. [Biography] In Portr. Svenska lak. apotek. (Sjoberg, N Stockh, 1910, 49, portr. HERO. See also Leadership. Altrock, D. von. Heldisches Erbgut. Mil. Wbl, Berl 1933, 118: 002.- Hayes, S. P, jr. Voters' attitudes toward men and issues. J. Social Psychol.. 1936. 7: Hi!--82.— benlz. T. F. Personage admiration and other correlates of conserva- tism-radicalism. Ibid, 1939. 10: 81 -9:5. MissrieiOer, A. Ueber das Verlieben in Autoren. Fortsch. S■■wvis.s. Psyrliaiial, 1926, 2: 513-8.—Mi\k. H. von. Sagenmotiye in historischen Berichten iiber die Ahstammung von Helden und Herrschern; ein Beitrag zur vergleichenden Sagenkunde. Mitt. Anthrop. Ges. Wien, 1934, 64: 199-228.—Thomson, D. F. Note, on a hero cult from the Gulf of Carpentaria, North Queensland. ,1. R. Anthrop. Inst. Gr. Britain, 1934, 64: 217-35, 3 p!. HEROARD, Jean. Luicm. Buchen (Odenw.) Witte- mann, 1937. HEROLD, Theodor, 1901- *Die noso- logischen Beziehungen der Acrodermatitis sup- purativa continua Hallopeau zur Psoriasis pustulosa und Impetigo herpetiformis. 37p. 22M>cm. Bresl., R. Nischkowsky, 1937. HEROLD, Walter, 1906- *Die Bezie- hungen der Krankheiten des Leber-Gallensystems zum Diabetes. 15p. 8? Lpz., K. Triltsch, 1931. HEROLD, Willy. See Pfaff, Wilhelm, & Herold, Willy. Grundlagen einer neuen Tnerapieforschung der Tuberkulose. 249p. roy. 8°. Lpz, 1937. HEROUX, Bruno. Der Mensch; Anatomie fiir Kiinstler. 8p. diagr. 28cm. Lpz., A. Seemann, 1938. HEROVEN, Luise, 190.")- *Die Behand- lung der Wehenschwache unter Beriicksichtigung grosser und kleiner Chiningaben [Bonn] 32p. 8? Wattenscheid, A. Grauthoff, 1935. HERPES. See also Ectodermosis; Herpes virus; also names of parts affected; also names of diseases produced as Bladder, Herpes; Encephalitis, herpetic; Eye, Herpes, &c Cumston, C. G. The history of herpes from the earliest times to the nineteenth century; with remarks on dermatologi- ral lesions in general. Ann. M. Hist, 1920, 8: 281-91 — Dubois. Lortat-Jacob [et al.] Herpes et zona. P. verb. Congr. derm. syph. fr, 1926, 3. Congr, 46-51 jDiscussion]—Gulden, K. Herpesgruppe, Pemphigusgruppe und Bluterkrankungen. Derm. Zschr, 1933, 66: 152-67.—Kuznitzky, E. Ibipes- Gruppe. Dermatologica, Basel, 1939, 79: 419-28.—Lehn- dorff, H. Herpes. In Handb. Kinderh. (Pfaundler, M. it Schlossmann, A.) 4. Aufl, Berl, 1935. 10: 451-63.—Ludy, J. B. Herpes simplex. In Cvclop. Med. (Piersol-Bortz) Phila, 1930, 7: 266-9.—Percival, G. H. Herpes. In Brit. Enc\ cl. M. Pract.- (Rolleston, H.) Lond, 1937, 6: 513-7. ---Associated disease. Mirski. J. A. *Herpes et chancre syphilitique. 25p. 8? Par., 1936. Forman, L, & Whitwell, G. P. B. The association of herpes catarrhalis with erythema multiforme (Hebra) Brit. J. Derm. Syph, 1934, 46: 309-11.—Goeckerman, W. H., & Wilhelm, L. F. X. Herpes zoster and herpes simplex; report of a case in which both appeared simultaneously: analysis of their etiology. Arch. Derm. Syph, Chic, 1937, 35: 808-74.— Koch, F. Herpes und Syphilis. Miinch. med. Wschr, 1936, 83: 1744.—Milian, G. HerpSs et syphilis. Bull. Soc. fr. derm. syph, 1936, 43: 76-8. Also Rev. fr. derm. vinir., 1936, 12: 3-11.—Naegeli. Experimenteller Vakzineherpes (Naegeli) mit jeweiligen Schiiben von dyshidrotischem Ekzem: Dyshidro- tisches Ekzem mit Neuritis. Schweiz. med. Wschr, 1926, 56: 349.—Willbrand, L. Rezidivierender Herpes simplex auf fruherem Impfschanker. Derm. Wschr, 1931, 93: 1219.— Zurukzoglu, S, & Griinberg, L. Herpes und zerebrospinale Lues. Schweiz. med. Wschr, 1933, 63: 259-61. --- Clinical aspect. Fuchs, W. [J.] *Uebcr eine Herpesepidemie in der Universitiits-Hautklinik Tubingen. 22p. 8? Tub., 1936. Vlavianos-Rudolph, M. [Monika] ♦Klini- scher Beitrag zum Horpesproblem. 19p. 8? Munch., 1930. Araki, S. Statistische Beobachtungen iiber Herpes zoster und Herpes simplex. Jap. J. Derm. Urol., 1937, 41: 97.— Kumer. Manifestazioni erpetiche e cliniche. Gior. ital. derm. sif, 1936. 77: 490- Loewenthal. W. Einige Herpes-Byob- achtungcr. Klin. Wschr, 1027, 6: 1800-901.- McFarland, A. R. A clinical study of herpes with a review of .".8 cases. \r. York State J. M.', 1934, 34: 637-40.—Roxburgh, A. C. The pathological relationships of the herpetic diseases from the clinical standpoint. Brit. J. Derm, 1927, 39: 13-26 — Spada, G. Caso di un erpete crasso osscrvato. Filiatre sebezio, Nap, 1835, 9: 21.—Weisstub, I. An interesting case of herpes. Canad. M. Ass. J, 1940, 42: 574. --- Diagnosis. Freund, H. Ueber den Nachweis des Herpeserregers bei zosteriformen Eruptionen (Darier) und seine differential- diagnostische Bedeutung. Arch. Derm. Syph, 1928, 154: PI8"8*'—?*ruf2ek' H. Localisations rares d'eruptio'ns de I herpes simplex et remarques sur le diagnostic differentiel entre l'herpes simplex, le zona et l'6pidermophytie. Rev fr. derm. ven6r, 1935, 11: 550-2— Lavergne, V. de', Kissel, P, & Simonin. J. Epid6mie hospitaliere d'infection herp6tique, s'Stant rev^lee k l'occasion de ponctions lombaires. Bull Soc. med. hop. Paris, 1934, 3. ser, 50: 200-4.—Thomas, C. C. \ irus infection resembling herpes simplex. Arch. Derm S\ nh Chic, 1940, 41: 179. ' ---- Etiology. Almeida Ribeiro, M. d'. *Breve estudo sobre o herpes. 71p. 8? Lisb., 1880. Flandin, C., & Levaditi, C. Herpes et zona, etiologie. 33p. 27cm. Brux., 1926. Also BruxeUes med, 1925-26, 7: 1197. Glantzberg, H. *Ueber die prognostische Bedeutung des Herpes bei Grippe und Pneu- monie. 22p. 23cm. Berl., 1936. Levaditi, C. L'herpes et le zona, ectodermoses neurotropes; etude etiologique et pathogenique. 388p. 8? Par., 1926. Muller, K. *Der gegenwartige Stand der Herpes simplex Aetiologie, zugleich ein Bericht zur Frage der H. s. Eruptionen bei Fieberbe- handelten. 27p. 8? Erlangen, 1933. NtiCKEL, A. *Herpes simplex und Herpes zoster im Zusammenhang mit zahnarztlichen Eingriffen und Zahnerkrankungen [Bonn] 31p. 8? Bad Neuenahr, 1935. Eliasberg, II. Klinische Beobachtungen iiber Herpeser- krankungen im friihen Kindesalter. Mschr. Kinderh, 1929, 42: 139-47.—Flandin. C. Herpes et zona, fitiologie. Rapp. Congr. derm. syph. fr, 1926, 3. Congr, pt 2, 1-15. Also Medecine, Par, 1926, 8: 189-91.—Hruszek, H. Zum Problem der Disposition beim Impf herpes; Beriicksichtigung des Geschlechts, Alters. Temperatur und der Blutgruppenvertei- lung. Derm. Zschr, 1933-34, 68: 200-9.—Lauda, E,[& Luger. A. Klinik und Aetiologie der herpetischen Manifestationen (Herpes simplex) Erg. inn. Med. Kinderh, 1926, 30: 377- 505.—Loewenthal, W. Zur Frage der Herpes-Aetiologie. Klin. Wschr, 1926, 5: 1616. Also Zbl. Bakt, 1. Abt, 1926-27, 101: 396-405, pl.—Lortat-Jacob. Eruption d'herp4s apparu k la suite d'injection de vaccin de Nicolle. P. verb. Congr. derm. syph. fr, 1926, 3. Congr, 55— Schonfeld, W. La importancia clinica del herpes simple para otras enfermedades y estados fisiologicos. Rev. med. germ. iber. amer, 1930, 3: 24-9.—Stalder, W, & Zurukzoglu, S. Ueber eine ausserge- wohnliche Eruption von Herpes simplex bei Sepsis (gleichzeitig ein Beitrag zum Antagonismusproblem) Derm. Wschr.. 1937, 104: 208-71.—Warren, S. L, Carpenter, C. M, & Boak, R. A. Symptomatic herpes, a sequela of artificially induced fever; incidence and clinical aspects; recovery of a virus from herpetic vesicles, and comparison with a known strain of herpes virus. J. Exp. M, 1940, 71: 155-68, pl. Also repr.—Yernaux, N. L'etiologie de l'herpes. Rev. med, Louvain, 1926, 257-60. ---- experimental. Back, H. Beitrag zur experimentellen Herpesforschung (vorlaufige Mitteilung) Klin. Mbl.-Augenh, 1926, 77: 360-3 — Blanc, G. Etat de nos connaissances d'ordre experimental sur l'herpes. Arch. Inst. Pasteur hellen, 1923-26. 1: 50-67. ------& Caminopetros, J. Recherches experimentales sur l'herpes. Ibid, 44-6.—Burnet, F. M, & Lush, D. Studies on experimental herpes infection in mice, using the chorioallantoic technique. J. Path. Bact, Lond, 1939, 49: 241-59.—Gastinel, P. Le virus herpetique et l'herpes experimental. Rev. med. fr, 1931, 12: 119-31.—Gildemeister. E, & Herzberg, K. Experimentelle Untersuchungen uber Herpes. Klin. Wschr, 1027, fi: 603.—Griitz, O. Infektions- und Reinfektionsversuche mit Herpesvirus an der Planta von Meerschwcinchcn. Arch. Derm. Syph, 1926, 151: 142-8.—Hiuszek, H. L'6volution clinique de l'herpes experimental recidivant. Rev. fr. derm. vener, 1933, 9: 532-41.------ Ueber eine experimentelle Folliculitis h'erpetica s.- Herpes foUicularis (perkutane Herpes- impfung und Beitrag zur Frage der naturUchen Gewebsm- fektion durch Herpesvirus) Derm. Zschr, 1933-34, 68: '58-75------Technisohe und klinische Bemerkungen zum Impfherpes Ibid, 325-31.—lacono. I. Ricerche sperimentali sull'erpete. Riforma med, 1928, 44: 416-21.—Le Fervie de Arric & Cohen, C. Etude experimentale d un cas d herpes generalise du k un virus fnible. C. rend. Soc. biol, 1929, 150: 405-7.--Naegeli, O. Ueber experimentellen Vakzineherpe* mit einem Anhang iiber tierexperimentelle Resultate bei verschiedenartigem dermatologisehem Material. Schweiz. med Wschr, 1926, 56: 25-30.—Nicolau. S, & Kopciowska, L. Neuro-infections exp6rimentales, mortelles, partiellcment autosteriUsees, chez le lapin. C. rend Soe biol, 1934, 115: 1094-6.—Pette, H. Tierexperimentelle Studien zur Irage der Viruswanderung im Nervensystem; Verimpfung von Herpes- HERPES virus (Herpes simplex) auf die Cornea. Deut. Zschr. Nervenh, 1931 121:113-43. ------ Verimpfuns von Herpesvirus in den N ischiadicus. Ibid, 144-64.—Teissier. P, Gastinel, P.. A- Rcillv, J. Conditions de receptivite duns linoculation exp'rinii ntale du virus herpetique. 1'. verb. Congr. derm. s>ph fr. (1923) 1925. 2. congr, 770-9. Also J. physiol. path. g^n, 1926, 24: 271-8-1. ------ Quelques donnees sur l'herpds experimental humain. P. verb. Congr. derm. syph. fr, 1020, 3. Congr, 56-8, 2 pl. ------ Apparition de troubles tro- phiciueif au cours de paralvsies herpetiques experimentales. C. rend. Soc. biol, 1020, 100: 254-6. ------ Sur l'herpes experimental du cobave. Ibid, 101: 557-9.—I'rbain, A, Gousartchek & SchaefTer. W. Sur linfection herpetique experimentale du cobaye; etude comparative des diverses voies d'inoculations. Ibid, 1027, 97: 540-51- Vieuchange, J. Voies de propagation des virus herpetique et poliomyeiitiquc inocuies dans le conduit externe. Ibid, 1930, 122: 359. ---- genital. Avit-Srr>tt. J. Recurring herpes genitalis in the male. Lancet, Lond, 1931, 1: 972.—Blanc, G, & Caminopetros, J. Quelques considerations sur l'herpes; elude experimentale de l'herpes genital. Arch. Inst. Pasteur helien, 1923-20, 1: 153-70.—Fontana, A. SuUa eziologia dell'herpes genitalis. Minerva med. Tor, 1925, 5: 897; 1926, 6: 257; 295.—Kov&ts, I. [Treatment of herpes progenitalis with Sozojodol natrium] Magy. noorv. lap, 1940, 3: 93-6.—Nudemberg, A, & Rechter. M. El herpes genital; su tratamiento por la infiltracion de novocafna. Dfa med, B. Air, 1938, 10: 1348-50.—Pezold, von. Herpes genitalis. Deut. med. Wschr, 1926, 52: 007.—Rabut, R. I'ne petite mis^re, d'observation courante, l'herpes genital. Hopital, 1938, 26: 348-50.—Sharlit, H. Herpes progenitalis as a venereal contagion. Arch. Derm. Syph, Chic, 1940, 42: 933-6. ---- gestational. See Dermatitis, herpetiform—in pregnancy. ---- Manifestation. Gottron, H. Aphthoid Pospischill-Feyrter, ein Beitrag zu den durch Herpesvirus bedingten Haut-Schleimhautverande- rungen. Mschr. Kinderh, 1038, 74: 82-99.—Kitchevatz, M. Eruption cutanee k virus filtrant au cours de l'herpes simple; herp6tides eruptifs. Bull. Soc. fr. derm, syph, 1034, 41: 481-4.—Lichault & Morvan. Fievre horpetiaue avec localisa- tion larvngee et labiale. Ann. otolar. Par, 1938, 575.— Massini, R. Febris herpetica. In Handb. inn. Med. (Berg- mann, G, et al.) Berl, 1934, 1: 698-701.—Member, S., * Bruger, M. Blood cholesterol in rabbits during experimental herpes virus infection treated with vitamin Bi and with sul- fanilamide. Proc. Am. Soc. Biol. Chem, 1939, 9: p. .-xix.— Pette, H. Beitrag zur Frage der Febris herpetica (Meningitis herpetica?) Acta med. scand, 1929, 70: 421-9.—Youmans, J. B. Herpetic fever with stomatitis: report and discussion of a case in which the virus was isolated. South. M. J, 1932, 25: 228-33. ---- Manifestation, meningeal and neural. See Encephalitis, herpetic. ---- menstrual. Abraham, E. G. Rezidivierender Herpes simplex (menstru- alis) des Intermenstruums mit bisher unbekannter Lokalisa- tion. Zbl. Gyn, 1934, 58: 2616-9.—Blum, R. Menstruelle Herpesrezidive. Ibid, 1926, 50: 540—Geber, H, & Rajka, E. Nachweis eines allergischen Zustandes bei Herpes menstrualis Derm. Wschr, 1930, 90: 737-41.—Godoy, E. Herpes cata- menial y novocafna. Sem. med, B. Air, 1938, 45: pt 2, 334- 6.—Memmesheimer. Herpes menstruationis recidivans der Mundschleimhaut. Derm. Wschr, 1937, 105: 1314. ---- Pathogenesis. Horing, K. *Liegt dem Herpes simplex eine Erkrankung der nervosen Centralorgane zu Grunde? 18p. 8? Tub., 1937. S< honfeld, W. Zoster und Herpes simplex 179p. 8? Berl., 1928. In Handb. Haut. Geschlechtskr, Berl, 1928, 7: T. 1. Albeaux-Fcrnet, M, & Collart, P. Les conceptions actuelles de l'herpe.s. Gaz. hop, 1933, 106: 1467-74.—Burnet, F. M, & Williams. S. W. Herpes simplex; a new point of view. Med .!. Australia, 1939, 1: 637-42.—Ebara, I. On the problem of zoster and herpes. Japan M. World, 1928, 8: 212-4.—Freund, H. Beitr ino -air Kenntnis von Herpes und Zn-ter \rr-h' Derm. Syph, Berl, 1928, 155: 282-92.------ * Hevmann. B. Lntersuchungen iiber Herpes -implex und Zoster. Zschr. Hyg, 1027, 107: 592-644.—Goueerot. Conception actuelle de 1 herpes. Rev. path, comp. Par, 1922, 22: 100-4.—Herpes simplex; a now point of view. Med. Press & Circ, Lond 1940 203: 78.—Hruszek, H. Der Impfhelpes; die Technik und Impfherpes nebst Beitrag zum Problem des Gewebsinfektions- mechanismus bei der naturUchen Herpesinfek'ion des Menschen Zschr. ges. exp. Med, 1934, 93: 195-211.—Kumer, L. Herpes- HERPES forschung und Klinik. Deliber. Congr. derm, internat. (1935) 1935-37, 9. Congr, 1: 337-46 [Discussionl 2: 24 L—Levaditi. C. Sur I'etiologie et la pathogenie de l'nerpcs et du zona Bruxelles mod, 1925-20, 6: 1390-400. Also Hupp. Congr! derm. syph. fr, 1926, 3. Congr, pt 2, 17-31. -Minami, S, & Khara. I. Beil rag zur Herpesfrage. Klin. W-'-lir, I!i26, 5: 310-4.—Patte, A. Les acquisitions reeentes sur la clinique, I'etiologie et la pathogenie de l'herpes. J. med. chir. Pur' 1936, 107: 505-18—Peyri, J. Contribution a la qucslion de l'herpes. P. verb. Congr. derm. syph. fr, 1020, .'{. Congr, 60-2. Also Commun. Congr. derm. syph. fr, 1020, 3. Congr,] 2: 45-7.—Rezek, P. Herpesstudien an Hand einer Ligenbeob- achtung. Med. Klin, Berl, 1926, 22: 05-8.—Sobenilicim, (;. Zum Herpcsproblem. Schweiz. med. Wschr, 1927. f>7: 27- 32.—Teissier, P., Gastinel, P., & Reilly, J. Le virus herpetique dans l'organisme humain. J. physiol. path. g6n, 1926, 24: 301-30. ------• L'herpes experimental humain; considera- tions pathogeniques. Ibid, 310-20, 3 pl.—Veress, F. V. Beitrage zur Pathogenese des Herpes simplex. Deliber. Coii"r derm, internat. (1935) 1935-37, 9. Congr, 2: 242-4.—Weizcl', R. Beitrag zur Kenntnis des Herpes simplex und zoster. Munch, med. Wschr, 1938, 85: 396.—Zurukzoglu, S, & Hruszek, H. Eine intraepidermale und kutane Herpcsrcak- tion? Schweiz. med. Wschr, 1933, 63: 970. ---- Pathology. Andervont, H. B, & Friedenwald, J. S. A case of vaccini- form blepharitis due to an atypical herpes virus. Bull. Johns Hopkins Hosp, 1928, 42: 1-7.—Bedson, S. P. Contribution to the discussion on the pathological relationships of the herpetic diseases. Brit. J. Derm, 1927, 39: 26-9. -Bo*orny, R. Zur Frage der odematosen Form des Herpes. Med. Klin., Berl 1935, 31: 109.— Coulet, M. Abces de la cloi,on nasale, suite d'herpes. Ann. otolar. Par, 1933, 344-6. GuifTrc, M. Sui rappoiti tra herpes simplex ed herpes zoster. Ann. clin. med. Pal, 1928, 18: 153-00.—Jirman, J. (Herpes and herpetic virus (clinical course, anatomy, etiology, pathogenesis of herpes and biology of herpetic virus)] Cesk. derm, 1931, 12- 26-207, 5 pl—Laudn. E, & Rezek, P. Zur Histopathologic das Herpes simplex. Virchows Arch, 1926, 262: 827-37.—Life- story of simple herpes. Lancet, Lond, 1939, 1: 647.—Loewen- thal, W. Mikroskopische Befunde bei Herpes. Zbl. Bakt, 1. Abt, 1925-26, 97: 139-46.—Meisel, A. [Herpes desquamans and its treatment with intravenous injections of natrii bromati] Belaruss. med. dumka, 1925, 2: 142-5.—Naegeli, O. Beobach- tungen von antagonistischer Wirkung des Herpes simplex s, febrilis bei akuten und chronischen Infektionskrankheiten; eine Anrogung zu einer klinischer Umfrage. Klin. Wschr, l!(.'i."> 14: 341-3.------Zur Biolo-ie des Herpes simplex (gleir.h- zeitig ein Beitrag zum Studium des Wosens des Herpesphaiio- mens) Munch, med. Wiehi., 1030, 83: 330-44.—Perdrau, I. It. Herpetic diseases. Brit. J. Derm, 1027, 39: 1-13, pl.—Robert, P. Ueber cigentiimliche verruciforme plaques nach Herpes simplex. Dermatologica, Basel, 1939, 79: 73-9.—Szodoray, L. [Pathology of herpes simplex] B6rgy6gy. urol. vener. szemle, 1941,19:29. ---- recurrent. Zehrer, G. *Zur Frage der Beziehungen zwischen rezidivierendem Herpes und Urtikaria. 37p. 8? Rostock, 1935. Also Derm. Wschr, 1936, 102: 6-8. Andre-Thomas. Herpes recidivant de la fesse et accidents nerveux. Medecine, Par, 1933, 14: 101-6.—Balog, P. Neo- salvarsan bei Herpes recidivans necroticus. Derm. Wschr, 1930, 90: 017.—Boutaut, H. R. P. Herpes recurrens. Med. J. Australia, 1942, 1: 243.—Burnet, F. M. Herpes recurrens. Ibid, 154.—Ciambellotti, E. Erpete recidivante del volto di probabile natura anafilattica. Dcrmosifilografo, 1928, 3: 523- 43.—Foster, P. D, & Abshier, A. B. Smallpox vaccine in the treatment of recurrent herpes simplex. Arch. Derm. Syph, Chic, 1937, 36: 294-301.—Freund, H. Die Behandlung des rezidivierenden Herpes mit Kuhpockenlymphe. Deut. med. Wschr, 1928, 54: 356.—Gordon, H. The treatment of herpes recurrens. Proc. R. Soc. M, Lond, 1941-42, 35: 45-8. ----- & Rolleston, J. D. Herpes recurrens. Brit. J. Derm. Syph, 1942, 54: 87-90.—Gougerot, Degos & Brouet. Herpes fixe r6cidivant sur base purpurique. Bull. Soc. fr. derm, syph, 1936, 43: 630.—Griffiths, G. Herpes recurrens. Med. J. Australia, 1941, 2: 752.—Hermans, E. H, & Schokking, C. P. [Herpes recidivans faciei] Ned. tschr. geneesk, 1940, 84: 4959.—Hruszek, H. Zur Behandlung des rezidivierenden Herpes. Derm. Zschr, 1933, 68: 27-33— Klodnitzky. N. N, & Danilova, A. N. [Experimental study of relapsing herpes] Sovet. med. Sibiri, 1931, 1: 71-82.—Lassueur. Note sur le traitement de l'herpes recidivant par la radiotherapie. Bull. Soc. fr. derm, syph, 34: 784—Levy-Franckel, A. Traitement des herpes recidivants par les corps colorants (eosinate de cesium, bleu de trypan) Bull. Soc. m6d. Paris, 1933, 254-8. Also J. med. Par, 1933, 53: 729.—Milian. A propos du traite- ment de l'herpes recidivant par la radiotherapie. Bull. Soc. fr. derm, syph. Par, 1927, 34: 783.— Nicolau, S, & Poincloux, P. R6sultats d'une greffe de peau saine faite en 1924 sur un doigt atteint d'herpes recidivant pendant les 5 annees pr6cedentes. C. rend. Soc. biol, 1028, 97: 360-3.—Nicolau. S, Portocalfi, H. R, & Motoc, A. L'herpes recidivant. Rev. St. med, Bucur., 1941, 30: 289-318.—Perm, L. L'herpesr6cidivant. Paris med., HERPES 621 HERPES VEGETANS 1933, 87: 55-62.—Schachter, M. Studio sopra un caso di crpete ricidivante. Pensiero med, 1934, 23: 376-80.—Thomas, C. C. Herpes simplex; a case of an unusually extensive, recur- rent type, apparently cured after autoserotherapv. Arch. Derm. Syph, Chic, 1941. 43: 817-21.—Tzanck. A, & Sidi, E. Traitement de l'herpes recidivant et tenace par des injections locales de novocaine. Bull. Soc. fr. derm, syph, 1934, 41: 1694-7.—Ullmann, E. V. Prevention of recurring herpes. Northwest M, 1939, 38: 15-8.—Wright, C. I. An unusual case of herpes recurrens. Brit. J. Child. Dis, 1926, 23: 132-6. --- Topography. Farmlett, G. *Contribution a l'etude de l'herpes geant de la face. 55p. 25cm. Lyon, 1937. Bruusgaard, E. Zwei Falle von aiisgebreitetem Herpes simplex, davon einer mit retrobulbiirer Neuritis. Derm. Wschr, 1930, 91: 1183-8.—Dechaume, M. Herpes atypique de la face k debut oedemateux. Rev. stomat. Par, 1939, 41: 403-5.— Frei, W. Beitrag zur Kenntnis des Herpes simplex insbesondere des Herpes der Hande. Derm. Wschr, 1931, 93: 1508-11.— Greco, N. V. Herpes simple hemorragico Ducal. Sem. med. B. Air, 1941, 48: pt 2, 801.—Long, P. H. Herpetic pharyngitis and stomatitis; a report of 3 cases. J. Clin. Invest, 1933, 12: 1119-25.—Nicolas, J, Rousset, J, & Colas, J. Trois cas d'herpes giant de la face. Bull. Soc. fr. derm, syph, 1930, 43: 1333-6.—Nicolas, J, Rousset, J, & Lavabre. Herpes g^ant de la face. Ibid, 1491.—Tindall, W. J. A case of herpes occipito-collaris. Lancet, Lond, 1939, 1: 1435. --- Transmission. Calmy, H. *Porteurs de germes herpetiques. 40p. 24>^cm. Par., 1939. Hruszek, H. Beitrag zum Problem der naturlichen Ueber- tragung des Herpes virus von Mensch zu Mensch; die venerische Ansteckung. Derm. Wschr, 1937, 105: 1150-2.—Scheer, K. Direkte Uebertragung des Herpes simplex von Mensch zu Mensch. Munch, med. Wschr, 1931, 78: 613.—Schmitz, H. J. Dreimalige naturliche Uebertragung des Herpes-Virus durch Geschlechtsverkehr. Derm. Wschr, 1937, 105: 1394.— Touraine, A., Renault, P, & Soulignac. Herpes recidivant transmis par un porteur sain de virus. Bull. Soc. fr. derm. syph, 1937, 44: 645-9. Also Rev. fr. derm, vener, 1937, 13: 467.—Zurukzoglu, S, & Hruszek, H. Die Uebertragbarkeit des Herpesvirus von Mensch zu Mensch. Zbl. Bakt, 1. Abt, 1933, 128: 1; 129: 375, pl, 1934, 131: 324. --- traumatic. Mackenrodt, H. *Ein Beitrag zur trauma- tischen Herpes-Genese unter Berucksichtigung neuzeitlicher Forschungsergebnisse. 16p. 21cm. Jena, 1937. Truong-Gia-Tho. *Herpes traumatique. lOOp. 8? Lyon, 1934. Findlay, G. M., & Macallum, F. O. Recurrent traumatic herpes. Lancet, Lond, 1940, 1: 259-61.—Pohl, L. Auftreten von Herpes simplex an der Wangenschleimhaut und Lippe im Anschluss an eine Mandibularisinjektion. Zschr. Stomat, 1927, 25: 763-5. --- Treatment. Byrnes, C. M. The treatment of the postherpetic neuralgias. N. England J. M, 1936, 214: 108-11.—Dainow, I. Note preliminaire sur le traitement de l'herpes et du zona par la vitamine C (acide ascorbique) Ann. derm, syph. Par, 1936. 7. ser, 7: 817-28.—Fisher, A. A. Treatment of herpes simplex with moccasin snake venom. Arch. Derm. Syph, Chic, 1941. 43: 444-6.—Frank, S. B. Formolized herpes virus therapy and the neutralizing substance in herpes simplex. J. Invest. Derm, 1938, 1: 267-82.—Hall, W. C. Radiation treatment of herpes simplex. Am. J. Roentg, 1938, 39: 393-6.—Kelly, R. J. Treatment of herpes simplex with mocassin venom. Arch. Derm. Syph, Chic, 1938, 38: 599-602.—Kuipers, F. C. [Studies on herpes; tetter and vitamin A] Ned.'tschr. geneesk, 1931, 75: 1108; pt 2, 3439, pl.—Post, G. Traitement de l'herpes. Rev. path, comp. Par, 1915, 15: 409.—Schmidt, F. R. Vaccination for herpes. Arch. Derm. Syph, Chic, 1935, 32: 106.—Schroeder, H. Chirurgische Beobachtungen zur Herpesfrage. Deut. Zschr. Chir, 1926, 195: 338-40.—Stalder, W, & Zurukzoglu, S. Experimentelle Untersuchungen iiber Herpes; transplantation herpesinfizierter Hautstellen, Reakti- vierung von abgeheilten, kiinstlich infizierten Hautstellen, Herpesbehandlung. Zbl. Bakt, 1. Abt, 1936, 136: 94-7.— Weinbren, M. A note on ultra-violet radiation in the treat- ment of herpes. Lancet, Lond, 1927, 2: 805. HERPES iris. See Erythema, exudativum multiforme. HERPES tonsurans. See Trichophytosis. HERPES vegetans. See Impetigo. HERPES virus. See also Encephalitis, herpetic: Virus. Holden M. *The nature and properties of the virus of herpes. 19p. 8? N Y 1932 Also J. Infect. Dis, 1932, 50: 219-36. vm?eH^!d' H- &a Sch,Ie|!ngei. M- Die Grossenbestimmung u??i , ?LpeoSyorU£ duic^ Zentnfugierversuche. Zschr. Hyg, 1933 115: 342-53.-Bedson, S. P. Some observations bearing ?026 27Ss-eA7n £erpes Vlrucs ^articles. Brit. J. Exp. Path, 1926-27 8: 470-0. —---& Riand, J. O. W. On the supposed bfd 1928P ^?^nRth°,j;,ru8efUof ^f fe£rilis and vaccinia. i,,ii» V28'.% 174-8.—Blanc, G. Recherches experimentales sur le virus de 1 herpes. Arch. Inst. Pasteur helien, 1923-26 1- ?'^BuggS' C'.W- KGreen< R G- Properties of horno- gemzed herpes virus. J. Infect. Dis, 1936 58- 98-104 — J-™6""' A- & Vochting, K Etudes sur le virus de l'herpes febrile. Rev. gin. opht, Geneve, 1920, 34: 409-21 —Gilde- meister, E. Herpes. In Handb. Viruskr. (E. Gildemeister et al. Jena, Bd 1, 1939, 362-84.-Lefevre de Arric, M r£ cherches experimentales sur le virus de l'herpes. Arch in- ternat. med. exp, Liege, 1925-26, 2: 835-906.—Levaditi C & Schoen. R. Recherches sur la morphologie du virus her- petique. C. rend Soc biol 1927, 96: 959-61, pl.—Mitamura. 1, Kitaoka, M. [et al.] Untersuchungen uber das Virus des Herpes simplex. Tr. Soc. path, jap, 1035, 25: 122-8 — Nicolau, S„ & Kopciowska, L. Virus herpetique et cataphorese C. rend. Soc biol 1930, 104: 290-3. ------ Virus herpetique et pH. Ibid, 967. ------ Etude sur l'inframicrobe her- petique mis en evidence dans la maladie nerveuse experi- mentale du lapin. Ibid, 1937, 126: 211-5.—Pincherle, M, & Vegni, R. Contributo alio studio dei rapporti fra virus del- i'herpes simplex e dell'herpes zoster. Sperimentale, 1926-27 80: 599-621—Remlinger, P, & Bailly, J. Contribution k I etude du virus herpetique (souche marocaine) Ann Inst Pasteur, Par, 1926, 40: 253-87. Also Paris med, 1926, 59: 536-8. Also Ann. Inst. Pasteur, Par, 1927, 41: 1314-29. ------ Sur la diffusibilite du virus herpetique. C. rend Soc biol, 1926, 94: 109-12.—Seidenberg, S. Untersuchungen (iber das Herpes- und Zostervirus. Zschr. Hyg, 1031, 112: 134-50.—Simon, C. E. The virus of herpes simplex. Internat" Clin, 1927, 37. ser, 3: 122-7.—Teissier, P, Gastinel, P., & Reilly, J. L'association chez l'homme des virus herpetique et vaccinal. P. verb. Congr. derm. syph. fr, 1026, 3. Congr 59.—Tenji Taniguchi, Masakazu Hosokawa [et al.] The virus of herpes and zoster. Jap. J. Exp. M, 1034, 12: 101-4, pl.__ Urbain, A, & Schaeffer, W. Contribution k l'etude experi- mental d'un virus herpetique (souche marocaine) Ann Inst Pasteur, Par, 1929, 43: 369-85.—Zinsser, H, & Tang,'F. F. Further experiments on the agent of herpes. J. Immun Bait, 1929, 17: 343-55. ---- Cultivation, and isolation. Beeuwkes, H. Isolierung des Virus von Herpes febrilis in einem Falle von Herpes zoster thoracalis. Schweiz Zschr allg. Path. Bakt, 1939, 2: 334-7.—Cheever, F. S. Cultivation of Herpes febrilis virus on agar slant tissue cultures. Proc Soc. Exp. Biol, N. Y, 1939, 42: 113.—Gastinel, P, Stefanescoi V, & Reilly, J. Sur la culture du virus herpetique in vitro et les modifications subies par ce virus. C. rend. Soc. biol, 1931 106: 450-3.—Gildemeister, E, Haagen, E, & Scheele, L. Ueber das Verhalten des Herpesvirus in der Gewebekultur Zbl. Bakt, 1. Abt, 1929, 114: 309-14.—Levaditi, C, Levaditi, J, & Giuntini, J. Tentatives d'isolement du virus herpetique Bull. Acad, med. Par, 1940, 123: 595-8. —Magrassi, F. Sulla coltivabilitii. in vitro del virus erpetico. Gior. batt. immun, 1936, 16: 769-85.—Perdrau, J. R. Preservation of the virus of herpes. Brit. J. Exp. Path, 1926-27, 8: 167-9.—Saddington, R. S. Cultivation of herpes virus, and use of the mouse in its titration. Proc. Soc. Exp. Biol., N. Y, 1932, 29: 1012-4. ---- Filtration. Elford, W. J, Perdrau, J. R, & Smith, W. The filtration of herpes virus through graded collodion membranes. J. Path, Cambr, 1933, 36: 49-54.—Levaditi, C, Paic, M, & Krassnoff, D. Determination des dimensions des ultravirus par l'ultra- filtration; le virus de l'herpes. C. rend. Soc. biol, 1936, 121: 805-8.—Minami, S, & Ehara, I. Ueber die Filtrierbarkeit des Herpes-Virus. Arch. Derm. Syph, Berl, 1926, 152: 664-9. ---- Immunology, and serology. Goldner, H. *Tierexperimentelle Unter- suchungen iiber die Immunitatsverhaltnisse zwi- schen Herpes simplex und Vakzine. 39 p. 8? Bresl., 1935. Andrewes, C. H. Tissue-culture in the study of immunity to herpes. J. Path. Bact, Edinb, 1930, 33: 301-12.—Bedson, S. P. Further observations on the mode of action of a viricidal serum. Brit. J. Exp. Path, 1929, 10: 364-70. ------ Im- munization with killed herpes virus. Ibid, 1931, 12: 254-60. HERPES VIRUS 622 HERPES VIRUS ------& Crawford, G. J. Immunitv in experimental herpes. Ibid, 1920-27, 8: 138-47.—Berry, G. P, & Slavin, H. B. The role of humoral immunity in the protection of the central nervous svstem of suckling mice against herpes virus given intranasally. J. Bact, Bait, 1940, 39: 66.—Brain. R. T. The demonstiation of herpetic antibody in human sera by complement-fixation, and the correlation between its presence and infection with herpes vim-. Brit. J. Exp. Path, 1032, 13: 166-71.— Burnet, F. M, inimunitat beim Meerschwein- chen. Zschr. Hyg, 1925-26, 105: 645-70.—Schultz, E. W, & Hoyt, J. Studies on the antigenic properties of the ultra- viruses; the antigenic properties of herpes virus. J. Immun, Bait, 1928, 15: 411-9.—Sheboldaeva, A. D. [Photodynamic vaccines against the virus of herpes-encephalitis] J. mikrob, Moskva, 1937, 18: 569-77.—Stroian, N. Reaction de fixation du complement chez les lapins immunises contre le virus herpetique. C. rend. Soc. biol, 1929, 100: 610-2.—Teis- sier, P, Gastinel, P, & Reilly, J. A propos de l'immunite herpetique et du pouvoir neutralisant des tissus in vitro. Ibid, 1928, 97: 1399-401.—Vieuchange, J. Sur un cas d'im- munite k legard du virus herpetique observe chez le lapin, a la suite de l'inoculation de ce virus par la voie du conduit auditif externe. Ibid, 1936, 122: 360-2.—Wollman, E, & Urbain, A. Recherches sur les proprietes antigenes des virus invisibles; production de sensibilisatrices pour le virus her- petique. Ibid, 1928, 99: 477-9. ---- Inclusion bodies. Cowdry, E. V. A comparison of the intranuclear inclusions produced by the herpetic virus and by virus III in rabbits Arch. Path, Chic, 1930, 10: 23-37.—Guiraud, P., & Thomas. A. J. Inclusion* acidophiles dans les cellule- epidermiques 50 jours apito la guerison d'un herpes cutane. C. rend. Soc. biol, 1928, 99: 5n7.—Lipschiitz, B. Zur Frage der Wertung der Herpes- und Zo-terkorperchcn. Med. Klin, Berl, 1926, 22: 1456.—Lucas. A. M, cv Herrmann, W. W. Effect of centrifu- gation on herpetic intranuclear inclusions with a note on cyto- plasmic inclusions of unknown origin in the rabbit cornea Am. J. Path, 1935, 11: 969-75, 2 pl. Also repr.—Luger & Lauda. Zur Frage der sogenannten Kerneinschlus.se bei der herpetischen Infektion. Zbl. Bakt, 1. Abt, 1925-26, 97: 135-9.- Rector. I, E, & Rector, E. J. The microincineration of herpetic intranuclear inclusions. Am. J. Path, 1033, 9: 587-91, pl.— Watanabe, H. Ueber Einschlusskorperchen bei Herpes simplex. Zbl. Bakt, 1. Abt, 1930, 96: 38-44, pl. ---- Neurotropism. Docrr, R, & Hallauer, C. Die primare Herpesmyelilis und ihre Beziehungen zum Infektiousmodus sonic zur Wirts- spezies. Zschr. Hyg, 1936, 118: 474-506- Gildemeister. F, & Watanabe, II. Leber den Nachwci-,\ on Herpesvirus in Liquor cerebrospinalis bei kutan mit Herpesvii us infi/ierten Kaninchen Zbl. Bakt, 1. Abt, 1930-31, 119: I'47 21)0.—Goodpasture! E. W. Herpetic infection, with special reference to involve- ment of the nervous system. Medicine, Halt, 1920, 8: 223- 43.—Le Fevre de Arric, M, & Millet. IM. Localisation de virus herpetique sur le nevraxe par voie sanguine sous l'in- fluence d'agents modificateurs dc la barri^re h6mato-enc6- phalique. C. rend. Soc. biol, 1926, 94: 782-4. Levaditi, C, 4 Haber, P. La neroprobasic du virus herpetique administr6 au lapin par voie nasale. Ibid., 1935, 119: 21-3.—Levaditi, (', 4 Vieuchange, J. Inoculabilite de certains virus neurotropes (herpes, en particulier) par la voie du conduit auditif externe. Ibid, 949-51.—Rose, G. Die Spontanneurotropie des Her- pesvirus beim Meerschweinchen. Zbl. Bakt, 1. Abt, 1025-20, 97: 140-50. ------ Ueber die pathogene Bedeutung des Herpesvirus fiir das menschliche Nervensystem. Med. Klin Brrl, 1026. 22: 1920.—Walthard, B. Die Einwarrderung und Ausbreitung des Herpesvirus im Zentralnei vensystem des Meerschweinchens. Kranksheitsforschung, 1027, 4: 471-500. ---- Occurrence in body. Hruszek, H. Impfversuch mit Eigenspeichel zum Nach- weis des Herpesvirus. Derm Wschr, 1033, 96: 677-80.— Schmidt. K. Experimentelle Untersuchungen iiber das Vor- kommen von Herpesvirus im Blut und Liquor bei Mensch und Tier. Zschr. Augenh, 1927, 63: 242-8.—Teissier, P, Gastinel, P, & Rcillv, J. Le virus herpetique dans l'organisme humain. C. rend. Soc. biol, 1926. 94: 377-9.—Zurukzo-flu. S. Ueber das Vorkommen von Herpesvirus im Liquor cerebrospinalis. Zbl. Bakt, 1. Ah'.., 1937, 139: 86-90. ---- Pathogenicity. Fischer, M. *Die Beziehungen des Herpes- virus zum Blut und zum Liquor cerebrospinalis [Basel] p. 102-2.-). 8? Berl., 1926. Also Zschr. Hyg, 1927, 107: Akazaki, K. Ueber das Vorkommen von Kernveriinderungen in herpes-infizierten Gewebekulturen. Arch. exp. Zellforsch, 1937, 20: 89-105, 3 pl.—Anderson, K. Pathogenesis of herpes simplex virus infection in chick embryos. Am. J. Path, 1940, 16: 137-55, 4 pl.—Andervont, H. B. Activity of herpetic vim.-, in mice. J. Infect. Dis, 1929, 44: 383-93. ------ Patho- genicity of 2 strains of herpetic virus for mice. Ibid., 45: 306-85.------Herpetic virus in mice: pathogenicity, immunity and susceptibility of the host. Ibid, 1931, 49: 507-29.—Beeuwkes, H. [Isolation of the virus of herpes febrilis in a case of herpes zoster thoracalis] Acta leiden, 1939, 14: 43-6.—Bergstrand, K. Kann Herpes-simplex-virus beim Menschen Lahmungen verursachen? Acta derm, vener, Stockh, 1937, 18: 224-8.—Browne, F. E. The action of the herpes zoster virus in its more unusual manifestations. Med, J. Australia, 1931, 2: 621.—Cowdry, E. V, Lucas, A. M, & Neff, C. F. Resistance of vitamin Bi and B2 deficient and nor- mal rats to intracerebral injection of herpes virus. J. Infect. Dis, 1935, 57: 174-82—Gildemeister, E, & Ahlfeld, 1. Ex- perimentelle Studien mit Herpesvirus an der weissen Minis. Zbl. Bakt, 1. Abt, 1936, 137: 241; 1. Abt, 1937, 139: 325.— Haber, P. Inlluencs de la glande thyroide sur la receptivite des lapins a 1'egard du virus herpetique. C. rend. Soc. bio!, 1935, 120: 420. Hruszek, H. Ueber die Virulenz- beziehungs- weise Infektiosititsunterschiede verschiedener Herpesstamme. Derm. WmIii., 1934, 98: 672-82.—Kopciowska, M. L, 4 Stroian, N. Sui la septinevrite provoqu6e par le virus herpeti- que introduit dans le cerveau de lapins. C. rend. Soc. biol, 1929, 100: 540-2.—Koppisch, E. Die Erzeugung einer pri- maren Myelitis des Lendenmarkes durch intravenose Injektion von Herpesvirus. Zschr. Hyg, 1935, 117: 635-49.—Levaditi, C, Schoen, R, & Reinie, L. Le phenomene de la mort subite ou precoce au cours de l'infection herpetique chez le lapin. C. rend. Soc. biol, 1931, 108: 1055-8.—Magrassi, F. Studii sull'infezione e sull'immuniti da virus erpetico; sul contenuto in virus del cervello, in rapporto a diversi ceppi di virus, a diverse vie d'infezione, a diversi fasi del processo infettivo. Zschr. Hyg, 10.35, 117: 501-28.—Nicvdau, S, & Dimancesci Nicolau, O. Sur les septinevrites provoquees par le virus herpetique dans l'organisme du lapin. C. rend. Soc. biol, 1028, 98: 206-9.—Nicolau, S, & Kopciowska, L. La morpho- logic de l'inframicrobe herpetique dans le tissu des animaux infectes experimentalement et le mecanisme de la formation des inclusions qu'il engendre dans les cellules. Ann. Inst. Pasteur, Par, 1938, 60: 401-31.—Olitsky, P. K, & Schlesinger, R. W. Effect of local edema and inflammation in the skin of the mouse on the progression of herpesvirus. Science, 1041, 93: 574.— Paulian, D. Le virus herpetique et la sclerose lateral amyo- trophique. Bull. Acad, med. Par, 1932, 3. ser, 107: 462-7.— HERPES VIRUS 623 HERPIN Pincherle, M, & Vegni, R. Di un reperto di virus dell'herpes simplex in vescicola di herpes zoster. Atti Accad. fisiocr. Siena, 1926, 10. ser, 18: 133-9— Remlinger, P, & Railly, J. Sur la receptivite du tissu cellulaire souscutane au virus herpe- tique. C. rend. Soc. biol, 1927, 96: 101-3.—Shaffer, M. F, &- Enders, J. F. Quantitative studies on the infectivity of the virus of herpes simplex for the chorioallantoic membrane of the chick embryo, together with observations on the inactivation of the virus by its specific antiserum. J. Immun, Bait, 1939, 37: 383-411.—Zurukzoglu, S, & Hruzsek, H. Beitrag zum Problem des Verbleibens des Herpesvirus wahrend der eruptions- freien Periode. Zbl. Bakt, 1. Abt, 1933, 130: 320-6. ■--- Resistance. Balo, J. [Virulence of herpes virus] Orv. hetil, 1929, 73: 125-30. Also Zschr. Hyg, 1929, 110: 599-002.— Boak, R. A, Carpenter, C. M, & Warren, S. L. The thermal inactivation time at 41.5! C. of 3 strains of herpes simplex virus. J. Exp. M, 1940, 71: 169-73. Also repr.—Gastinel, P, & Reilly, J. A propos des herpes recidivants; les reviviscences experimentales du virus herpetique. Bull, med. Par, 1928, 42: 830-41.— Gundersen, T. Germicidal effect of ultraviolet rays on the virus of herpes; experimental studies. Arch. Ophth, Chic, 1932, 8: 519-29.—Heuer, G. Widersteht Herpesvirus der Austrocknung? Zbl. Bakt, 1. Abt, 1920. 113: 393.—Holden, M, & Molloy, E. Further experiments on the inactivation of herpes virus bv vitamin C (1-ascorbic acid) J. Immun, Bait, 1937, 33: 251-7.—Holden, M, & Resnick, R. The in vitro action of svnthetic crystalline vitamin C (ascorbic acid) on herpes virus. Ibid, 1930, 31: 455-62.—Hruszek, H. Versuche iiber die Resistenz des Herpesvirus. Derm. Mschr, Lpz, 1934, 98: 73-8.------Weitere Resistenzpriifungsversuche am Herpesvirus durch in vivo-Experimente. Ibid, 485-94.— Levaditi, C, Mezger, J. C, & Schoen, R. Action du tellure sur le virus herpetique. C. rend. Soc. biol.. 1932, 109: 1118-20.— Perdrau, J. R. Inactivation and reactivation of the virus of herpes. Proc. R. Soc, Lond, 1931, 109: ser. B, 304-8 — Remlinger, P, & Bailly. J. Le virus herpetique dans ses passages de chat k chat. C. rend. Soc. biol, 1926, 94: 734—6. ----- Sur le fiechissement de la virulence du virus herpetique marocain. Ibid.,1929, 101: 349-51.—Smith, W. The effect of testicular passage on the virus of herpes. J. Path. Bact, Lond, 1931, 34: 747-50.—Terry, T. L. X-rays ineffective against herpes virus. Am. J. Ophth, 1928, n. ser, 11: 554.— Zinsser, H, & Seastone, C. V, jr. Further studies on herpes virus; the influence of oxidation and reduction on the virulence of herpes filtrates. J. Immun, Bait, 1930, 18: 1-9. HERPES zoster. See Zoster. HERPETIFORM dermatitis [DuhringJ See Dermatitis, herpetiform [Duhring] HERPETOMONAS. See also Leishmania; Leptomonas; Trypano- somidae. Adler, S, & Theodor, O. The identity of Leishmania tropica Wright, 1903, and Herpetomonas papatasii Adler, 1925. Ann. Trop. M. Parasit, Liverp, 1926-27, 20: 355-62, 2 pl.—Ayroza Galvao, A. L, & Coutinho, J. O. Nota sobre um flagelado parasita de anofelinos du subgenero Nyssorhynchus, Herpetomonas pessoai, n. sp.; Mastigophora, Trypanosomiae. Rev. brasil. biol, 1941, 1: 311-9.—Bayon, H. P. Herpetomonas in the cloaca of African chamaeleons. Parasitology, Lond, 1926, 18: 361.—Becker, E. R. Herpetomonas arctocorixae sp. nov. entozoic in the intestine of the water-boatman Arctocorixa interrupta Say. J. Parasit, Urbana, 1927-28, 14: 85-7.— Bellosillo. C. C. Herpetomonas muscarum (Leidy) in Lucilia sericata Meigen. Philippine J. Sc, 1037, 63: 285-305, 5 pl.— Drbohlav, J. J. The cultivation of Herpetomonas muscarum (Leidy 1856) Kent 1881 from Lucilia sericata. J. Parasit, Urbana, 1925-26, 12: 183-90, 2 pl. Also repr.—Glaser, R. W. The isolation and cultivation of Herpetomonas muscae domes- ticae. Am. J. Trop. M, 1926, 6: 205-16, 2 pl.—Hoare, C. A. A note on the specific name of the herpetomonad of the house- fly. Tr. R. Soc. Trop. M. Hyg, Lond, 1923-24, 17: 403-6 — Noguchi, H. Comparative studies of herpetomonads and leish- manias; differentiation of the organisms serological reactions and fermentation tests. J. Exp. M, 1926, 44: 327-37. ------ 4 Tilden. E. B. Comparative studies of herpetomonads and leishmanias; cultivation of herpetomonads from insects and plants. Ibid, 307-24, 6 pl. Also repr.—Poisson, R. Sur un Herpetomonas parasite en Normandie de Spilostethus (Lygaeus) saxatilis (Scop.) (hemipteres Lygeoidea) a propos des phyto- flagelloses. C. rend. Soc. biol, 1930, 103: 1057-61. ------ Herpetomonas tortum n. sp, parasite intestinal des Camptopus lateralis (Germ.) (hemipteres Coreida\ Alydaria) des environs de Banyuls; role possible de cet insecte comme agent transmetteur de phytoflagellose. Ibid, 1061-4.—Rodhain, J. Le mode de transmission de Herpetomonas rhinaestri Rod. Ibid, 1926, 95: 1128-30. s HERPIN, Alexandre] 1880- & IMBERT, ' Alexandre. Prothese amovible. 2 p 1 387p . illust. 24^cm. Par., J. B. Bailliere & fils, 1939. a- Forms v.13, Traite stomat. (A. Herpin, Croquefer, et al.) e I HERPOBDELLA. 1 See also Hirudineae. a Emden, M. van. Bau und Funktion des Botryoidgewebes von Herpobdella atomaria Carena. Zschr. wiss. Zool 1929 134: 1-83, 3 pl, tab. HERR, Anne Laure, 1904- *Les nephro- . pathies graves consecutives a la transfusion , sanguine. 108p. 2 pl. 8? Par. [n. pub.] 1933. ■> HERR, Bruno, 1909- *Ueber den- Ein- • fluss des Thyroxins auf den Phosphatstoffwechsel s [Munster] 19p. 8? Werne-Lippe, F. Grube, - 1934. e HERR, Charles. Contribution a l'etude du r pollen des dipsacees. 61p. 8? Strasbourg, C. ■ Roch, 1934. HERR, E. A. The gladiolus thrips, Taenio- '-> thrips gladioli M. & S. 68p. 8? Wooster, Ohio, i 1934. e Forms No. 537, Bull. Ohio Agr. Exp. Sta. e HERR, Friedrich, 1902- *Das arztliche - Berufsgeheimnis. 41p. 8? Freib. i. B., Gebr. r Gunther, 1929. f HERR, Lucien, 1864-1926. Andler, C. Necrologie. J. psychol. norm, path. Par, 1926, s 23: 779-87. • HERR, Marie, 1911- *Zur Hygiene des t Tabaks auf Grund von Untersuchungen der . Mundhohle bei 400 Tabakarbeiterinnen [Miin- 8 chen] 32p. 20 '/jcm. Pfaffenhofen, Ilmgau-Dr., s 1936. e HERRAN, Alberto L., 1903- *De l'amelio- ration des races bovines indigenes par l'importa- tion de reproducteurs frangais en Colombie [Alfort] 72p. map. 4 pl. 8? Par., P. Bossuet, 1930. HERRAN, Joaquin E. Estudio clinico y electrocardiografico del bloqueo auriculoventricu- lar completo en la difteria. 158p. illust. tab. 27cm. B. Air., El Ateneo, 1939. HERRARTE, Carlos, 1901- Contribu- tion a l'etude des accidents cardio-vasculaires dans les anevrysmes arte>io-veineux. 66p. 8? Par., Le Francois, 1930. t HERREL, Michael Friedrich, 1910- . *Vergleichende Untersuchungen iiber einige Kurz- ' narkotioa der Barbitursaurereihe. 25p. 8: 1 Giessen, H. Meyer, 1937. HERREN, Magda, 1902- *Ueber einen 3 Fall von foetaler Eventration bei eineiigen Zwil- ' lingen. 19p. 8° Miinch., W. Hutter, 1927. i HERRENKNECHT, Luise, 1911- *Ueber [ die Kieferosteomyelitis [Heidelberg] 31p. 8? . Mannheim, Haas, 1934. HERRENSCHMIDT, Andre, 1874-1933. Roussy, G. [Necrologie] Bull. Ass. fr. cancer, 1933, 22: • 517-24, portr. HERRENSCHMIDT, Jean Louis, 1908- *L'histamine et la tyramine ou cours des pneumo- pathies tuberculeuses et non tuberculeuses. 158p. 25cm. Par., L. Arnette, 1938. HERRENSCHWAND, F. von, 1881- Parinaud'sche Conjunctivitis; Tularaemia ocu- loglandularis. 45p. 8? Berl., S. Karger, 1935. Forms H. 19, Abh. Augenh. HERRERA, Guillermo, 1905- *Lutte antilepreuse dans la Republique Dominicaine. 49p. 8? Par., Ed. Jel, 1935. HERRERA, Juan Alberto. *Reacciones cu- taneas-estreptoc6ccicas. 104p. 26}£cm. B. Air., A. Frascoll, 1940. HERRERA HERRERA Espinoza, Virginia. *Contribu- ci6n al estudio del Sophora tetraptera (Pilo) [Univ. Chile] 23p. 8? Concepci6n, Impr. Esmeralda, 1930. HERRERA S., Victor. *Aparatos de fijaci6n para dientes movibles en parodoncia [Univ: Chile] 45p. 8? Avenida, W. Gnadt, 1934. HERRERA Vegas, Rafael, 1834-1910. [Cranwell. D. J. [Biografia] In his Nuestros grand, med, B. \ir, 1937, 11-38—Yaben, J. R. IBiografia] Biogr. argent. (Yaben, J. R.) B. Air, 1938-40, 30: 90-2, portr. HERRFURTH, Reinhold, 1901- *Ein Beitrag zur Kenntnis der Pulmonalsklerose (Pulmonalsklerose und Polyglobulie) 16p. 8? Rostock, Adler, 1932. HERRFURTH [William Bernhard] Wolfgang, 1910- *Untersuchungen zur Formgestaltung des Gaumens in seiner Entwicklung vom Kinde bis zum Greise [Leipzig] 18p. 8? Sommerfeld, H. Mertsching, 1935. HERRGOTT, Alphonse, 1849-1927. Couvelaire. [Necrologie] Bull. Acad, med. Par, 1927, 3. ser, 98: 266-8.—Fruhinsholz, A. [N6crologie] Rev. med. est, 1927, 55: 533-8, portr. HERRICH-SCHAEFFER, Otto, 1908- *Die Einwirkung von Phosphaten, Trauben- zucker und Lezithin auf das Froschherz. 23p. 8? Konigsb. i. Pr., J. Raabe, 1933. HERRICK, Charles Judson, 1868- Brains of rats and men; a survey of the origin and biological significance of the cerebral cortex. xiii, 382p. 8? Chic, Univ. Chicago press [1926] ---- An introduction to neurology. 4. ed. p. 1. 406p. 8? Phila., W. B. Saunders co., 1927. Also 5. ed. p. 1. 417p. 1931. For Anniversary volumes see J. Comp. Neur, 1932, 56: pt 1; 1933, 57: pt 2. See also Herrick. C. J. Scientific pioneering in the Middle West. Sc. Month, 1942, 54: 49-56. HERRICK, Clarence Luther, 1858-1904. Coghill. G. E. Clarence Luther Herrick as teacher and friend. J. Comp. Neur, 1941, 74: 39-42.—Herrick. C. J. Incubaiion stages of scientific investigation. Sc. Month, 1942, 54: 361-9. HERRICK, Francis Hobart, 1848-1940. Obituary. Current Biogr, N. Y, 1940, 1: 384. For portrait, photograph, see collection in library. HERRICK, Glenn Washington] 1870- , & GRISWOLD, Grace H. The fumigation of greenhouses to destroy insect pests. 20p. 8? Ithaca, N. Y., 1929. Forms No. 474, Bull. Cornell Univ. Agr. Exp. Sta. HERRICK, James Bryan, 1861- Holmes W. H. James Bryan Herrick; an ap- preciation. 44 p. s? [Chic] 1935. (Biography] In Cardiac Classics (Willius. F. A.) S. Louis, 1941, 814-6, portr.—Dr .lames B. Herrick receives distinguished service award. J. Am. M. Ass, 1939, 112: 2155.—Portrait. Nu Sigma Nu Bull, 1940-41, 30: opp, 5; 107. HERRICK, Richard M., 1865-1941. [Obituary] Illinois M. J, 1941, 79: 439. HERRIG, Fritz, 1907- * Welche Be- deutung ist amniogenen Verwachsungen fiir die Entstehung von Missbildungen beizumessen? 18p. 8? Greifsw., H. Adler, 1934. HERRING, Arthur P., 1875-1923. Young, H. H. Presentation of a portrait of Dr Arthur P. Herring. Tr. Med. Chir. Fac. Maryland, 1925, 127: 423-6. HERRING. See also Clupeine; Fish. Keller. H. Siisse Salzheringe. Zschr. Fleisch Milchhvg 1940-41, 51: 198.—Klykov. A. A. [Material on the biology of the black-backed h 11111-] Bull. Acad. sc. URSS, 1940, ser. biol, 717-40—Maclennan, K. Herrings as food j' State M, Lond, 103 1. 42: 5ss-98.—Reay, G. A. The place of refrigeration in the i>ie-erVation of the herring as food Ibid., 602-6.—Salovius, I., Wegelius, C, & Wegelius, R [On the origin of vitamin D in salt herring] Fin. lak srll hand, 1937, 80:245-53. HERRINGHAM HERRINGHAM, Wilmot Parker, 1855-1936. L, R. A. [Biographv] S. Barth Hosp. J, Lond, 1035-30 43: 159-61.—Obituary. Brit. M. J, 1936. 1: 915; 965; portr. Also Lancet, Lond, 1930, 1: 1030-2, portr. Also S. Barth Hosp. Rep, Lond, 1936, 69: 27-39, portr. For portrait, photograph of a painting, sec Collection in library. HERRLEIN, Erich, 1905- * Ueber akute Verlaufsformen bei Herzklappenentziindung mit Streptokokkus viridans als Erreger. 25p. 8°. Erlangen, K. Dores, 1934. HERRLEN, Gunter, 1904- *Pharma- kologische Prufung von Analgetika. 15p. 8°. Tub., E. Gobel, 1933. HERRLEN, Hartmut, 1907- *Versuche zur Pharmakologie der Zellvermehrung. 21p, 8? Tub., E. Gobel, 1933. HERRLICH, Albert, 1902- *Zur Statis- tik der mannlichen Gonorrhoe. 15p. 8? Miinch. Bayer. Druck, 1931. HERRLIGKOFFER, Carl B. Kampfer um Leben und Tod; Gedanken, Plaudereien und Erlebnisse aus 40 jahrigem Arzttum. 239p. 8? Miinch., J. F. Lehmann, 1937. HERRLIGKOFFER, Siegfried, 1906- *Statistische Untersuchungen an 60 durch Unfall sicher Hirnverletzten [Wurzburg] 12p. 8! Gunzburg a. D. [n. pub.] 1931. HERRLINGER, Hilde, 1910- *Ueber Osteodystrophia fibrosa [Munchen] 28p. 8? Diisseld., G. H. Nolte, 1935. HERRLINGER, Robert, 1914- *Die Milzgefasse der weissen Ratte [Heidelberg] p.34-47. 23}£cm. Lpz., Breitkopf & Hartel, 1938. Also Zschr. mikr. anat. Forsch, 1938, 43: HERRMANN, Adolf, 1912- *Untersuchun- gen iiber die Mundbodenphlegmone und ihre Aetiologie, mit einem eigenen Fall. 23p. 21cm. Tiib., K. Bolzle, 1938. HERRMANN, Albin, 1903- *Das Leben Jean Cruveilhiers und sein Einfluss auf die Entwicklung der pathologischen Anatomie. 32p. 8? Diisseld., Gater, 1931. HERRMANN, Alfons, 1894- *Die Ein- wirkung der Rachitis auf Kiefer und Zahne. 52p. 8? BerL, R. Pfau, 1933. . HERRMANN, August, 1907- *Zur Be- wertung der Mitralstenose in der Schwanger- schaft. 32p. 8? Bonn, H. Ludwig, 1933. HERRMANN, Bruno, 1907- *Versuche der Ekzembehandlung mit Fissanpraparaten [Leipzig] 50p. 8? Neu-Isenburg, Gebr. Vogel, 1934. HERRMANN, Charlotte, 1909- *Gan- gran- und Granulombehandlung mit Diathermie. 32p. 8? Bresl., K. Vater [1933] HERRMANN, Egon, 1910- *Ueber eine Ostitis fibrosa localisata des Unterkiefers bei einem 17jahrigen Madchen. 27p. 8? Tub., A. Becht, 1938. HERRMANN, Elisabeth, 1911- *Ueber Herpes corneae [Heidelberg] 19p. 21cm. Mannheim, J. P. Walther, 1936. HERRMANN, Erich, 1909- *Ist die Extraktion von Zahnen zwecks orthodontischer Behandlung indiziert? 23p. 8? Munch., Gebr. Giehrl, 1932. HERRMANN, Erich, 1912- *Die Me- thode des Vincenz Priessnitz und ihre Bedeutung fiir seine Zeit und die Gegenwart. 35p. 8? Erlangen, M. Dores, 1936. HERRMANN, Ernst, 1899- *Ueber die Radikaloperation des Mittelohres. 18p. 8? Heidelb., J. Horning, 1930. HERRMANN 625 HERRMANN HERRMANN, Ernst [Friedrich Franz] 1901- *Die Haufigkeit der progressiven Paralyse. lip. 2 1. 8? Rostock, G. Neumann, 1935. HERRMANN, Franz Josef, 1905- *Zum Problem der Uebertragung [Munchen] 46p. 8? Kallmiinz, M. Lassleben, 1930. HERRMANN [Franz Richard] Wilhelm, 1906- *Morbiditat und Mortalitat bei Probe- Excisionen, Exkochleationen und Abrasionen. 16p. 8? Munch., C. Wolf & Sohn, 1931. HERRMANN, Friedrich, 1905- *Ueber die Missbildungen an der stadtischen Frauen- klinik Stuttgart aus den Jahren 1915-1937. 39p. 22^2cm. Tub., A. Becht, 1939. HERRMANN [Friedrich] Wolfgang, 1910- *Zahnleiden und Erwerbsunfahigkeit. lOp. 8? Lpz. [n. pub.] 1934. HERRMANN, Georg, 1891- & POTZL, Otto. Die optische Allaesthesie; Studien zur Psychopathologie der Raumbildung. 302p. 8? Berl., S. Karger, 1928. Forms H. 47, Abh. Neur. Psychiat. HERRMANN, Georg, 1907- *Beitrag zum Pneumokokkenproblem unter besonderer Berucksichtigung der Serumtherapie. 15p. 21cm. Berl., Neuland-Druck, 1936. HERRMANN, Georg [Heinrich Paul] 1901- *Ueber Fremdkorper nach Schussverletzungen [Leipzig] 42p. 8? Zeulenroda, A. Oberreuter, 1937. HERRMANN, George Rudolph, 1894- Clinical case-taking; supplement to Methods in medicine. 90p. 8? S. Louis, C. V. Mosby co., 1927. Also 2. ed. 98p. 1934. ---- Synopsis of diseases of the heart and arteries. 344p. illust. pl. diagrs. 20cm. S. Louis, C. V. Mosby co., 1936. Also 2. ed. 468p. illust. 3 pl. diagr. 1941. HERRMANN, Gerhard, 1905- *Unter- suchungen iiber Zahnveranderungen bei inneren Krankheiten. 39p. 8? Kiel, C. Schaidt, 1932. HERRMANN, Gerhard, 1906- *Ueber das Verhalten der Blutkorperchensenkungsreak- tion bei akuten Infektionskrankheiten [Rostock] 19p. 8? Gustrow, C. Michaal, 1933. HERRMANN, Gertrud. Formen des Ge- meinschaftslebens jugendli'cher Madchen; sozial- psychologische Untersuchungen in einem Fiir- sorgeerziehungsheim. 160p. 8? Lpz., J. A. Barth, 1929. Forms Beih. 46, Zschr. angew. Psychol. HERRMANN, Gustav, 1854- Precis d'anatomie pathologique. 2. 6d. rev. par C. Morel. 2 p. 1. 809p. 8 pl. 8? Par., G. Doin & cie, 1926. See also Tapie. J, & Morel, L. Precis d'anatomie patho- logique. 3. 6d. 700p. 8? Par, 1937. HERRMANN, Hans, 1904- ♦Unter- suchungen iiber den Einfluss von Vigantolle- bertran auf den Heilungsverlauf von Unter- kieferfrakturen bei Hunden. 14p. 8? Erlangen, Muller [1931] HERRMANN, Hans, 1908- *Das Auf- treten von Arterientonen bei korperlicher (sport- licher) Arbeit und seine sportarztliche Bedeutung. p.621-35. 8? Bresl., Genossensch.-Buchdr., 1934. Also Arbeitsphvsiologie, 1931-32, 5: HERRMANN, Hans, 1910- *Verglei- chende Versuche iiber die analgetische Wirkung von Pyramidon und Urethan allein und ihrer Kombinationen. 16p. 2 ch. 2 1. 8? Halle, Merseburger, 1932. HERRMANN, Hans, 1910- *Ueber die Herstellung und die Eigenschaften fester Alumi- 227475—vol. 7, 4th series----40 niumazetate mit besonderer Berucksichtigung der pharmazeutischen Praxis [Erlangen] 38p. 6 pl. 21cm. Lauf, H. Farmer, 1938. HERRMANN, Hans, 1913- *Kreislauf- storungen als Grippefolge. 17p. 21cm. Schwa- bisch Gmund [n. pub.] 1938. HERRMANN, Hans [Paul Heinrich] 1909- *Beitrag zur Pathologie der Odontome [Leipzig] 36p. 8? Zeulenroda, A. Oberreuter, 1932. HERRMANN, Use, 1910- *Zur Frage der Facialisparesen nach zahnarztlichen Ein- griffen [Basel] 19p. 8? Rottweil, M. Roth- schild, 1934. HERRMANN, Johannes, 1900- *Ver- anderung der Mundhohle bei Skorbut (Auszug) [Leipzig] 7p. 8? [Roding, Oberpfalz] [n. pub.] HERRMANN, Johannes, 1911- *Beitrag zur Frage der fokalen Infektion unter besonderer Berucksichtigung der chronisch-granulierenden Periodontitis [Wurzburg] 26p. 8? Zeulenroda, A. Oberreuter, 1934. HERRMANN, Karl Oskar, 1907- "'Ex- perimentelle und klinische Untersuchungen iiber die Stippchengallenblase. 41p. 21cm. Giessen, H. Grimm, 1937. HERRMANN, Kurt, 1901- *Zur paroxys- malen Haemoglobinurie [Frankfurt a. M.] 38p. 8? Bonn [n. pub.] 1929. HERRMANN, Louis G[eorge] 1900- Pas- sive vascular exercises and the conservative management of obliterative arterial diseases of the extremities. xx, 288p. illust. pl. 8? Phila., J. B. Lippincott co. [1936] HERRMANN [Ludwig Erich] Albrecht, 1896- *Ueber die Austastung des Uterus nach rechtzeitiger Geburt und ihre Morbiditat [Leip- zig] 20p. 8? Oschatz, C. Morgner, 1925. HERRMANN, Margarete, 1905- *Beob- achtungen iiber den Einfluss der Nahrungs- temperatur auf das Verhalten des Sauglings [Breslau] p.49-69. 8? Berl., F. C. W. Vogel, 1931. Also Mschr. Kinderh, 1931, 51: HERRMANN, Martin, 1895- ♦Unter- suchungen iiber den Calziumspiegel des Blut- serums nach kalten Seebadern. 20p. 8! Rostock, Winterberg, 1931. HERRMANN, Martin, 1897- *Ueber den Zusammenhang zwischen Lebensalter und pul- pentoten Zahnen; korrelationstheoretische Un- tersuchungen [Munchen] 20p. 8°. Wurzb., R. Mayr, 1935. HERRMANN, Martin, 1908- *Ist das Gesetz zur Verhiitung erbkranken Nachwuchses imstande, die Huntington-Chorea-Familien zum Aussterben zu bringen? 20p. 8? Erlangen, R. Windsheimer, 1935. HERRMANN, Ottmar, 1908- *Was ist bisher iiber allgemeine Gesundheitsstorungen als Ursache der Entstehung von kariosen Erkran- kungen der Zahne bekannt geworden? [Wurzburg] 31p. 8? Ochsenfurt, Fritz & Rappert, 1934. HERRMANN, Rene. *Le traitement des varices et de ses complications par les injections phlebosclerosantes de biiodure de mercure. 44p. 8? Geneve, Impr. Jent S. A., 1927. HERRMANN, Richard, 1911- *Halluzi- nose-ahnliche Bilder im Anschluss an die Malaria- behandlung bei progressiver Paralyse [Wurz- burg] 30p. 20^cm. Erlangen, M. Dores, 1938. HERRMANN, Robert Charles Albert, 1911- *L'atelectasie pulmonaire [Lille] 124p. 24cm. Par., A. Legrand, 1934. HERRMANN 626 HERSCHEL HERRMANN, Rudolf. Die Praxis des Hamo- gramms in der Diagnostik der Lungentuberku- lose. 34p. 8? Lpz., J. A. Barth, 1933. Forms H. 50, Tuberk. Bibl, Lpz. HERRMANN, Rudolf, 1907- *Beitrag iiber die Verwendung des Dialysierverfahrens nach Abderhalden auf dem Gebiete der Psychia- tric nebst einigen Hinweisen hinsichtlich seiner praktischen Durchfuhrung [Halle] 35p. 8? Grossenhain, H. Plasnick, 1935. HERRMANN, Rudolf, 1911- lnter- suchungen auf Rasse- und Korperbautypen bei Epileptikern. 22p. 8? [Miinch., Gorlitzer Nach.] 1936. HERRMANN, Valentin, 1906- *Die Regeneration des Kieferknochens nach Wurzel- spitzenresektionen. 33p. 2 pl. 8? Wiirzb., C. J. Becker, 1932. HERRMANN, Walter, 1909- ♦Granu- losazelltumoren und ihre Strahlenempfindlich- keit. 31p. 8? Freib. i. B., T. Kehrer, 1935. HERRMANN [Walter] Gerhard, 1912- ♦Ueber das Wiederauftreten der Krebserkrankung innerhalb der ersten fiinf Jahre nach der Opera- tion. 25p. 22cm. Wiirzb., R. Mayr, 1937. HERRMANN, Wilhelm, 1903- *Ueber die im Glasblaserberufe vorkommenden Schadi- gungen und Erkrankungen des Mundes und der Zahne, sowie deren Prophylaxe und Therapie [Breslau] 21p. 8? Berl., J. Springer, 1930. Also Zbl. Gewerbehyg, 1930, 193; 218. HERRMANN, Wilhelm (Christian Hermann] 1904- *Ein Fall von Varixbildung der Vena manna Galeni. 45]). 8? Halle, O. Jung, 1929. HERRMANN, Willi, 1910- *Ueber Kie- ferbriichi'. 15p. 8? [Konigsb., n. pub.] 1936. HERRMANN, Wolfgang, 1913- *Der Vorfall von Nabelschnur und kleinen Teilen und seine Behandlung [Leipzig] 57p. 8? Eisfeld C. Beck, 1937. HERRMANNSDORFER, Adolf, 1889- See Herrmannsdorfer. M, & Herrmannsdorfer. A. Koch- buch fiir Tuberkulose. 4. Aufl. x, 153p. 8° Lpz, 1931. HERRMANNSDORFER, Mimicia, & HERR- MANNSDORFER, Adolph. Kochbuch fur Tu- berkulose. 4. Aufl. x, 153p. 8? Lpz., J. A. Barth, 1931. HERRNBERGER, Kurt, 1911- *Zur Behandlung der mannlichen Gonorrhoe mit Argentum aceticum [Kiel] lip. 8° Berl R. Pfau, 1935. HERROLD, Maude M., 1854- Woman and disease; a collection of facts for women 324p. 8? Kansas City, Mo., 1896. HERROLD, Sherman E., 1906- ♦Pem- phigus der Conjunctiva mit Berucksichtigung eines besonderen Falles. 28p. 8° Heidelb Brausdruck, 1937. '' HERROU, Henri, 1911- *Contribution a 1 etude des kystes sereux des ligaments du foie- a propos d'une observation. 43p. 8° Par' Libr. Le Francois, 1937. '' HERSCH, Leib Sachs, 1914- *Etude sur 1'acidose du nourrisson. 63p. 24cm Par Impr. fr. Central., 1939. HERSCHAN, Otto. Klinik der Entwicklungs- storungen. p.396-436. Lpz., C. Kabitzsch, In Handb. inn. Sekret. (Hirsch) 3. Bd, 1. Halfte. ^-—. GELLER, C. [et al.] Die klinische Pa- thologie der weiblichen Geschlechtsorgane im Rahmen der endokrinen Storungen. p. 395 Lpz., C. Kabitzsch, 1928. In Handb. inn. Sekret (Hirsch) 3. Bd, 1. Halfte. HERSCHEL, Sir William, 1738-1815. Bolton. S. K. [Biography] In her Famous Men of So N. Y, 1938. 58-75. HERSCHENSOHN, Herbert Lawrence, 1902 ♦Prevention of peritonitis and adhesions [Marquette Univ. Hosp.] 16p. 4? Milwaukee Wis., 1927-28. Typewritten. HERSCHMAN, Myer Jerome, 1894-1941. [Obituary] Med. Ann. District of Columbia, 1942, 11: 82 HERSCOVICI, Herscu, 1898- *La palu- disme en Roumanie et sa prophylaxie. 53d. 8° Par., M. Vigne, 1929. HERSCOVICI, Herscu, 1909- *Le chancre syphilitique; accident professionnel du medecin et de ses collaborateurs. 45p. 8? Par L Arnette, 1936. HERSCOVICI, Leon Arie, 1904- ♦Con- tribution a l'etude des 6paules raides et dou- loureuses; peri-arthrites scapulo-humerales; calci- fications peri-articulaires; fibrosite de l'epaule; arthrites acromio-claviculaires. 102p. 8? Par.' Press, modern., 1934. HERSCOVICI, Samuel, 1906- *De l'in- fluence m6dicale frangaise en Roumanie. 63p 8? Par., Impr. Studio, 1933. HERSCOVICI, Strul, 1908- ♦L'hygiene des ouvriers dans l'industrie des couleurs d'aniline 52p. 8? Par., M. VignS, 1936. HERSCU, Moise, 1911- ♦Contribution a l'etude des phlebites a bascule d'origine traumati- que (forme hyperalgique) 37p. 8? Par., E. Le Francois, 1937. HERSHEY, Emma. Chiropractic defined and defended; facts that are stranger than fiction xv, 189p. pl. 8? Akrion, O. [1929] HERSHMAN, Arthur, 1909- ♦Zwei Falle von gonorrhoischer Sepsis nach chirurgischem Eingriff. 31p. 8? Ziir., Fluntern, 1936. HERSHSON, Julien, 1910- ♦Contribu- tion k l'etude des tumeurs malignes p^dicul^es de l'isthme du gosier, de l'hypopharynx et du larynx. 113p. 8? Par., L. Rodstein, 1934. HERSKOVITS, Melville Jean, 1895- The anthropometry of the American Negro. xv, 283p. 8? N. Y., Columbia Univ. press, HERSKOVITS, Rudolf, 1908- ♦Re- cherches sur Taction physiologique, les propriSt&i pharmacodynamiques et l'emploi therapeutique de Blumea balsamifera D. C. 37p. 8 ch. 25cm Par., Vigot freres, 1939. HERSZBERG, Pauline, 1909- ♦Con- tribution a l'etude de Tecoulement sanglant par le mamelon symptomatique d'une tumeur du sem. 61p. 3 pl. 25cm. Montpel., Mari-Lavit, 1934. HERSZENKRUG, Szewach, 1913- *De l'emploi de la transfusion du sang dans le traite- ment de l'infection puerperale. lOOp. 25cm. Lyon, Janody, 1938. HERTAULT, Arthur Edmond Hubert, 1864- *Les viandes foraines [Alfort] 75p. 8? Par., Le Francois, 1929. HERTEL, Arthur, 1885- ♦Sinngebung der Geomedizin. 37p. 8? Berl., Neuland, 1935. HERTEL, Ernst, 1870- Farbenproben zur Prufung des Farbensinnes. 20. neu bearb. Aufl. der Stilling'schen Tafeln. 15p. 33 pl. 24cm. Lpz., G. Thieme, 1939. See also Axenfeld, Theodor, & Hertel. Ernst. Lehrbuch und Atlas der Augenheilkunde. 772p. 8° Jena, 1935. Also editor of Stillings pseudo-isochromatische Tafeln zur Prufung des Farbensinnes. 17. Aufl. [3]p. 8? Lpz, 1926, Also 18. Aufl. 12p. 8! Lpz., 1929. HERTEL HERTEL, Harald, 1906- *Ueber den Geschmack einiger organischer Salze. p.152-60. 8? Jena [n. pub.] 1933. Also Zschr. Psychol. Physiol. Sinnesorg, 2. Abt, 1933, 64: HERTEL, Heinz [Wolfgang] 1907- *Das Verhalten der Urindiastase bei Erkrankungen des Magens [Leipzig] 26p. 8? [Zeulenroda, A. Oberreuter] 1931. HERTEL, Luise, 1911- ♦Zur Patho- genese der multiplen Sklerose [Munchen] 24p. 8? Speyer, Pilger, 1938. HERTEL, Wilhelm, 1881-1930. Seiderer, F. Nekrolog. Munch, med. Wschr, 1931, 78: 760. HERTER, Franz, 1903- ♦Experimentelle Untersuchungen iiber die therapeutische Be- einflussung des anaphylaktischen Shocks beim aktiv sensibilisierten Meerschweinchen. 13p. 8? [Miinst., n. pub., 1932] HERTER, Konrad, 1891- Fang, Pflege und Zucht der deutschen Susswasseregel. p. 1577- 618. 8? [Berl., 1936] In Handb. biol. Arbeitsmeth. (Abderhalden, E.) Berl. 1936, 9: pt 2. HERTERICH, Franz, 1911- ♦Entwick- lung und heutiger Stand der Schulzahnpflege in Deutschland. 27p. 8? Wurzb., C. J. Becker, 1936. HERTFORD, Engl. General Infirmary. An- nual reports. Hertford, 57.-64. (1889-96) 1890-97. HERTFORD County, Engl. County Tubercu- losis Officer. Annual report [Hertford] 1.-18. (1913-30) 1914-31. HERTFORDSHIRE. North Hertfordshire and South Hertfordshire Infirmary. Annual reports. Hitchin, 41.-44. (1880/81-1883/84) 1881-84. HERTIG, Owen Lovejoy, 1865-1933. [Obituary] Frater, Menasha, 1933-34, 40; 46, portr. HERTING, Johannes, 1863- Carl Wigand Maximilian Jacobi, ein deutscher Arzt (1775- 1858) ein Lebensbild nach Briefen und anderen Quellen. 218p. 12 pl. 8? Gorlitz, C. A. Starke, 1930. See also Sioli, F. Zum Goldenen Doktor-Jubilaum von Direktor i. R. Sanitatsrat Dr Johannes Herting. Psychiat. neur. Wschr, 1938, 40: 131. HERTLE, Josef, 1871-1931. Payr, E. Nekrolog. Munch, med. Wschr, 1931, 78: 1268, portr. For portrait, photograph, see Collection in library. HERTLEIN, Hans, 1910- ♦Pharma- kologische Untersuchungen iiber das Kombina- tionspraparat Cardiazol-Chinin [Erlangen] 25p. pl. 8? Wiirzb., K. Triltchs, 1936. HERTLING, Helmuth, 1891- Die Ziich- tung von Meeresfischen fiir wissenschaftliche und praktische Zwecke. p. 195-366. illust. diagrs. 8? Berl., Urban & Schwarzenberg, 1938. In Handb. biol. Arbeitsmeth. (Abderhalden, E.) Berl, 1938, Abt. 9, T. 6, Bd 2. HERTLING, Klaus, 1908- ♦Betrachtun- gen iiber den Wert klinischer Untersuchungs- methoden fiir dei Abgrenzung der vererbbaren von der erworbenen Taubheit. 31p. 22}£cm. Halle, W. Hendrichs, 1938. HERTNECK, Hilde, 1909- *Ueber den feineren Gefassaufbau normaler Nieren und iiber Veranderungen dieser Gefasse bei einigen renalen und extrarenalen Erkrankungen [Tubin- gen] 58p. 8? Bottrop, W. Postberg, 1934. HERTNECK, Wolfgang, 1910- *Klinische Untersuchungen zur Wismutbehandlung und Wismutprophylaxe der Angina. 18p. 21cm. Munch., F. X. Seitz, 1938. HERTNER HERTNER, Willi, 1912- *Zur Frage der Entstehung der Osteome der Nasennebenhohlen [Berlin] 17p. 21cm. Urach (Wurttb.) F. Biihler, 1937. HERTOGHE, Eugene. D'Hollander. Eloge du Doctor Eugene Hertoghe. Bull. Acad. med. Belgique, 1935, 5. ser, 15: 474-81, portr. HERTRAMPF, Helmut, 1911- ^Die Befestigungsmoglichkeiten der einfachen partiel- len Plattenprothese und deren kritische Aus- wertung. 47p. 8? Lpz., A. Edelmann, 1935. HERTRAMPF, Horst [Karl Otto] 1909- ♦Ueber die Geburt bei jugendlichen Erstge- blirenden [Breslau] 41p. 21cm. Ohlau, H. Eschenhagen, 1937. HERTRAMPF, Karl, 1893- ♦Mehrfache Wirbelsaulenbrtiche vom Standpunkt des Ge- richtsarztes. 23p. 8? Bresl. [L. Freund] 1926. HERTRICH, Hans, 1910- ♦Versuche einer Erklarung der therapeutischen Wirkung von Ammoniumjodid bei Asthma bronchiale. 18p. 8? Halle, H. John, 1934. HERTSLET, Lewis Eccles, 1877- Skin; its uses in 6 phases, xviii, 206p. 8? Lond., J. & A. Churchill, 1929. HERTWIG, G[unther] 1888- , STUD- NICKA, F. K., & TSCHOPP, E. Die lebendige Masse; allgemeine mikroskopische Anatomie und Organisation der lebendigen Masse, xii, 626p. roy. 8? Berl., J. Springer, 1929. Forms Bd 1, pt 1, Handb. mikr. Anat. Menschen (Mollen- dorff) See also Hertwig, Oscar & Hertwig, Gunther. Allgemeine Biologie. 822p. 8? Jena, 1923. HERTWIG, Hugo. Gesund durch Heil- pflanzen; altes und neues Wissen vom Kampfe der Pflanze gegen die Krankheit und von ihrer Kraft menschliches Schicksal zu gestalten. 3. Aufl. xii, 300p. • pl. 8? Berl., Verl. Kultur- politik [1937] HERTWIG, Oscar, 1849-1922, & HERTWIG, Gunther. Allgemeine Biologie. 6. & 7. Aufl. xvii, 822p. 8? Jena, G. Fischer, 1923. HERTWIG, Paula, 1889- Partielle Kei- messchadigungen durch Radium und Ront- genstrahlen. 2 p. 1. 48p. illust. diagrs. 8? Berl., Gebr. Borntraeger, 1927. Forms C, Bd 3, Handb. Vererbwiss. (E. Baur & M. Hart- mann) ---- Artbastarde bei Tieren. iv, 140p. illust. 26^cm. Berl., Gebr. Borntraeger, 1936. Forms Lig 21 (Bd 2, B) Handb. Vererbwiss. (E. Baur & M. Hartmann) HERTWIG, Richard, 1850-1937. Der Or- ganismus der Radiolarien. 2. Bd, 3. H. 2 p. 1. p.129-277. 10 pl. fol. Jena, G. Fischer, 1879. ---- Lehrbuch der Zoologie. 2 T. iv; vii, 588p. paged consec. illust. 8? Jena, G. Fischer, 1891-2. ---- Abstammungslehre und neure Biologie. 3 p. 1. 271p. 2 pl. 8? Jena, G. Fischer, 1927. ---- Ueber den Bau der Peripyleen (Sphae- roideen) 40p. 5 pl. 4? Miinch., C. H. Beck, 1932. Forms H. 12, n. F, Abh. Bayer. Akad. Wiss. For biography see Deut. med. Wschr, 1935, 61: 1819, portr. (O. Koehler) Also Munch, med. Wschr, 1937, 84: 1785, portr. (K. von Frisch) HERTWIG, Richard, 1908- ♦Ueber die Zahnung und ihre Folgen fiir den kindlichen Organismus. 17p. 8? Wurzb., R. Mayr, 1932. HERTZ, Arthur Frederick. See Hurst, Sir Arthur Frederick. HERTZ, Friedrich, 1878- Rasse und Kultur; eine kritische Untersuchung der Ras- sentheorien. 3. Aufl. xii, 426p. 8? Lpzr., A. Kroner, 1925. HERTZ (>2^cm. Quakenbruck, R. Kleinert, 1936. HERZIG [Maximilian] ♦Etude sur la thora- coplastie. 40p. 8? Lausanne, Impr. reunies S. A., 1925. HERZLICH, Chaim, 1905- ♦L'insuline huileuse dans le traitement du diabete sucre\ 48p. 8? Par.. M. Vigne, 1932. HERZLICH, Helene, 1905- ♦L'emploi du lait calcique dans la di£t6tique du nourrisson. 82p. 8? Par., A. Legrand, 1936. HERZNEUROSEN und moderne Kreislauf- therapie. See Bad-Nauheim. Vereinigung der Bad-Nauheimer Aerzte. HERZOG, Adolf, 1902- ♦Die trau- matische Thrombose der Vena axillaris oder der Vena sub'clavia [Hcildeberg] 15p. 8? Wall- dorf, Fr. Lamade, 1929. HERZOG, Alfons, 1904- ♦Gebissunter- suchungen an tiofstehenden Idioten. 39pl 8? Bonn, P. Kubens, 1931. HERZOG, Alfred W., 1868-1933. Richmond, F. ('. (Obituary] Med. Leg. J, N. Y, 1933 50- 33. HERZOG, Dietrich. Vergleichende Mor- phologie des Blutes. p. 1229-318. Berl., Urban & Schwarzenberg, 1932. In Handb. allg. Hamat, Bd 1, 2. Halfte. HERZOG, Dragutin, 1905- ♦Ueber Haem- angiome der Mundhohle. 48p. 2 pl. 8° Berl E. Ebering, 1929. HERZOG, Elizabeth G. See American anthropologist. General index, 1929-38 122p. 24cm. Menasha, 1940. HERZOG, Ernst, 1898- ♦Desarrollo, importancia y tendencias de la anatomia pato- 16gica [Univ. Chile] 14p. 8? Santiago, Impr Univ., 1931. H " HERZOG, Ferenc, 1879 For jubilee volume see Orvoskepzes, 1939; 29: Deo. kulonf. HERZOG, Georg, 1910- ♦Die Beziehun- gen der Konstitutionsforschung zu zahnarzt- lichen Problemen. 26p. 8? Miinch . Baver Druck. 1935 "jci- HERZOG.' Gisela, 1909- *Krankheit und Tod im Alter (Feststellungen am Leichengut des Pathologischen Instituts Gottingen in den Jahren 1901 bis 1934) 28p. 8? Weende F Pieper, 193ri. HERZOG, Heinrich, 1875-1938. Knapp, E Nekrolog. Hah, &c. Arzt, 1938, 29: 354 — Krainz, W. Heinnch Herzog zum Gednchtnis. Arch Ohr. &c. Heilk, 1938. 145: 240.------Nekrolog. Mschr. Ohrenh 1938, 72: 727. HERZOG, Heinrich, 1905- ♦Ein Fall von Chondrom der Xase. 18p. 8? Erlangen K. Dores, 1931. HERZOG, Heinz. 1910- ♦Fall von Orbitalthrombose nach Zahnextraktion und an- schliessender Kieferhohlencntzundung. 25p 23cm. Berl., Baron & co., 1937. HERZOG, Joseph, & HANNER, A. |)j(. chemischen und physikalischen Prufungsnietlio- den des deutschen Arzneibuches 5. Ausjrabo 2. Aufl. iv, 425p. 8? Berl., J. Springer, 1021 HERZOG, Karl [Franz] 1910- *Ki„ Beitrag zum sogenannten Gallertkrebs dor Brustdriise [Giessen] p.163-204. 8? \aum- burg, Lippert & co., 1937. Also Beitr. path. Anat, 1937, 99: HERZOG, Kurt, 1905- *Wirkungen von sportlichen Bewegungsablaufen in den Gelenken; Beitrag zur Aetiologie der Sportschaden in den Gelenken bei Leichtathletrk, Fussball und Boxen [Berlin] 36p. tab. 8? Charlottenb., Gebr Hoffmann, 1931. HERZOG, Kurt [Karl Johannes] 1910- ♦Statistische Erhebungen iiber Zahnerkrankun- gen beim Pferde. 48p. 8? Lpz., A. Edelmann, 1937. HERZOG, Ludwig, 1908- ♦Untersuchun- gen iiber die Einbettmasse Neobrillat bei Temperaturen von 800° bis 1200D. 12p. 8° Wurzb., K. Triltsch, 1933. HERZOG, Maximilian, 1858- A con- tribution to the study of the nature of enzvmes 107p. 8? Chic, M. Herzog [1919]? HERZOG, Oskar, 1911- ♦Saurefett- milch (ein Beitrag zur Uebungstherapie bei ernahrungsgestorten Sauglingen) 32p. 21Ucm Wiirzb., R. Mayr, 1938. HERZOG, Otto, 1901- ♦Ascites chylosus bei retroperitonealer Carcinose und Tuberkulose. 23p. 8? Tiib., E. Gobel, 1930. HERZOG, Otto, 1910- ♦Ueber verzoger- ten Durchbruch der Zahne. 21p. 8? Erlangen Thieme, 1936. HERZOG, Rudolf, 1871- Die Wunder- heilungen von Epidauros; ein Beitrag zur Geschichte der Medizin und der Religion. 164p. pl. 8? Lpz., Dieterich'sche Verlags- buchh., 1931. HERZSTEIN, Joseph, 1893- The prin- ciples of healthful ventilation. 38p. 8° N Y Nat. Tuberc. Ass., 1926. HESCH, Mfichael] See Schultz, K, & Hesch, M. Rassenkundliche Bcstim- mungs-Tafcln. 4p. 16? Miinch, 1935. —— & SPANNAUS, Gunther. Kultur und Rasse; Otto Reche zum 60. Geburtstag ge- widmet von Schulern und Freunden. 428p. illust portr. tab. diagr. 25#cm. Munch., J. F. Lehmann, 1939. HESEDING, Alfons, 1905- ♦Tierex- perimentelle Untersuchungen iiber die Infektion mit Bazillus abortus Bang [Munster] 27p. 8? Lohne-Oldbg, B. Puttmann, 1933. HESELER [Paul] Otto, 1901- ♦Ueber die Pathogenese, Klinik und Therapie des Vvackelknies in seiner Beziehung zum Liga- mentum collateral tibiale [Leipzig] p. 145-72. 8? [Wurzb., H. Stiirtz] 1927. Also Wiirzb. Abh. Med, 1928-29 25: HESKETH, Florence E. See Wertheimer, Frederick Ignace, & Hesketh, Florence K. ire sl|,r'incanRe of the physical constitution in mental disease. 70p. 8? Bait, 1926 HESKIA 631 HESPERIS HESKIA, Jacob, 1908- *R61e des elimina- tions d'hormones dans le diagnostic et pronostic des m61es hydatiformes et chorio-epitheliomes. 123p. 8? Par., L. Rodstein, 1935. HESNARD, Angelo Louis Marie, 1886- La psychoanalyse. 21p. 8? Par., Masson, 1923. In C. rend. Congr. alien, neur. France, 1923, 27. Congr. ---- Les psychoses et les frontieres de la folie. viii, 278p. pl. 12? Par., E. Flammarion, 1924. ---- Les syndromes nevropathiques. 2 p. 1. 247p. 8? Par., G. Doin & cie, 1927. See Oudard, Pierre, Hesnard, A, & Coureaud, H. Le diagnostic dans les affections de la colonne vert6brale. 256p. 8! Par, 1928 HESPE, Heinz, 1903- ♦Ueber Atresie der Gallenwege im Sauglingsalter; klinische Beobachtung und pathologisch-anatomische Un- tersuchung zweier zu verschiedener Zeit der Entwicklung entstandener Falle [Kiel] 18p. 8? .Stuttg. [n. pub.] 1927. HESPEL, Henry, 1910- *Le diagnostic precoce de la gestation chez la jument de pur sang par le dosage de la folliculine dans l'urine [Alfort] 80p. 8? Saumur, Impr. M. Chevalier, 1933. HESPERIDIN. See also Flavone; Vitamin. Armentano, L, Bentsath, A. [et al.] Ueber den Einfluss von Substanzen der Flavongruppe au4 die Permeabilitat der Kapillaren; Vitamin P. Deut. med. Wschr, 1936, 62:1325-8.— Bentsath, A, & Das, N. B. Ueber den Vitamin P-Test. Zschr. physiol. Chem, 1937, 247: 258-61.—Lajos, S, & Gerendas, M. Spektrographische Untersuchung des Vitamins P (Citrin) und anderer flavonartiger Stoffe. Biochem. Zschr, 1937, 291: 229-36.—Lorenz, A. J, & Arnold, L. J. Preparation and esti- mation of crude citrin solutions, vitamin P, from lemons. Food Res, 1941, 6: 151-6.—Lotze, H. Untersuchungen iiber das Vitamin P. Zschr. ges. exp. Med, 1937-38, 102: 697-727. ----- Kritisches iiber das Vitamin P. Deut. med. Wschr, 1938, 64: 477-80.—Moll, T. Zur Frage des Vitamin P. KUn. Wschr, 1937, 16: 1653.—Morii, S. Research for vitamin P. J. Biochem, Tokyo, 1939, 29: 487-501.—Review of current research on lemon citrin, vitamin P. Nutrit. Res, 1940-41, 1: No. 3, 1.—Robeznieks, I. Kritische Beobachtungen zur Vitamin P-Frage. Zschr. Vitaminforsch, Bern, 1938-39, 8: 27-31.—Rusznyak, I., & Szent-Gyorgyi, A. Vitamin P: flavonols as vitamins. Nature, Lond, 1936, 138: 27.—Sadikov, V. [Vitamin P] Priroda, Leningr, 1937, 26: 92.—Scar- borough, H. Vitamin P. Biochem. J, Lond, 1939, 33: 1400-7.—Scarzella. M. Contributo clinico alio studio della vitamina P, citrina. Pediat. med. prat. Tor, 1939, 14: 65-78.—Synthetic vitamin. Brit. Food J, 1940, 42: 82.— Szent-Gyorgyi, A. Methoden zur Herstellung von Citrin. Zschr. physiol. Chem, 1938, 255: 126-31.—Vacek, V. Neuere Erkenntnisse uber Vitamin P. Schweiz. med. Wschr, 1941, 71: 155-9.—Yosida, K. [Studien uber Hesperidin] Mitt. Med. Ges. Osaka, 1941, 40: 471; 545.—Zilva. S. S. Vitamin P. Biochem. J, Lond, 1937, 31: 915; 1488. --- Pharmacology, and therapeutics. Armentano, L., Bents&th, A. [et al.] [Influence of flavones upon clpillary permeability; vitamin P] Orv. hetil, 1936, 80: 935-8— Armentano, L., Hatz, E. B, & Rusznyak, I. [P- vitamiije in urine] Ibid, 1938, 82: 1016-9—Higby, R. H. The chemical nature of hesperidin and its experimental medical use as a source of vitamin P; a review. J. Am. Pharm. Ass, 1941, 30: 629-35.—Hiramatsu, N. [Studien uber das Vitamin P (Hesperidin) uber den Einfluss des Hesperidins auf die Serum- Anaphylaxie] Jap. J. Derm. Urol, 1941, 49: 304-11.----— [Studien uber das Vitamin P, Hesperidin; iiber den Einfluss des Hesperidins auf die Serum-Anaphylaxie unter den Funk- tionsstorungen des Retikuloendothelsystems] Ibid, 50: 37- 45.— Huszak. S. Ueber das Schicksal parenteral einverleibter Citrinlosung im Tierkorper. Zschr. physiol. Chem, 1937, 249: 214-6—Lajos, S. [Clinical experiences with Citrin (vitamin P)] Orv. hetil, 1938, 82: 642.— Leser, A. J, Lombard, C. F. [et al.] The effect of vitamin P on the circulatory system. J. Pharm. Exp. Ther, 1941, 72: 26.—Mulli, K. Klinische Erfah- rungen mit Citrin (Vitamin P) Klin. Wschr, 1938, 17: 135.— Raunert, M. [Hemostatic effect of P-vitamin] Magy. urol, 1938, 1: 332-6.—Scarborough, H, & Stewart, C. P. Effect of hesperidin, vitamin P, on capillary fragility. Lancet, Lond, 1938, 2: 610-2.—Schaber, E. E. Akute Ekzeme und toxische Dermatitiden. Schweiz. med. Wschr, 1941, 71:1511 (Abstr.)— Vacek, V. [Experiences with vitamin P] Cas. lek. cesk, 1941, 80: 329-33, HESPERIS. See also Hesperidin. Davril, S. Les vertus des plantes; la julienne des jardins- tlcspens matronahs, crucifies. Bruxelles mid., 1928-29, 9: Suppl, p. dcccxxxiv. HESPEROPITHECUS. See also Apes; Man, Origin. Gregory, W. K. Hesperopithecus apparently not an ape nor a man. Science, 1927, 65: 579-81. HESPERS, Maria, 1909- *Indikations- stellung und Operationserfolge bei Myom- operationen. 21p. 8? Konigsb., J. Raabe, 1936. HESRY, Henri, 1910- ♦Essai sur les relations entre la migraine, l'epilepsie, l'urticaire et l'oedeme de Quincke, 1'asthme, le coriza spasmodique, la psychose depressive. 61p. 8? Par., Vigot freres, 1936. HESS, Alfred Fabian, 1875-1933. Rickets, including osteomalacia and tetany, xv, 485p. pl. 8? Phila., Lea & Febiger, 1929. ---- Collected writings. 2v. 719p; 734p. illust. pl. portr. diagr. 26^cm. Springf., 111., C. C Thomas, 1936. For biography see Am. J. Dis. Child, 1934, 47: 635-9, portr. Also Hebrew M. J, N. Y, 1938, 2: 189-92 (B. Weiss) Also Med. Life, N. Y, 1934, 41: 615-7 (S. R. Hagan)- Also Science, N. Y, 1934, 79: 70-2. For portrait see collection in library. HESS, Carl, 1863- Die Anomalien der Refraktion und Akkommodation des Auges mit einleitender Darstellung der Dioptrik des Auges. ix, 523p. 105 illust. 8? Lpz., W. Engelmann, 1903. Forms 8. Bd, 2. Abt, Handb. ges. Augenh. (T. Saemisch & C. Hess) 2. Aufl. ---- Pathologie und Therapie des Linsen- systems. 357p. 90 illust. pl. 8? Lpz., W. Engelmann, 1905. Tn 6. Bd. 2. Abt, Handb. ges. Augenh. (T. Saemisch & C. Hess) 2. Aufl. ---- Methoden zur Untersuchung des Licht- und Farbensinnes sowie des Pupillenspieles. p. 159-364. 8? [BerL, 1937] In Handb. biol. Arbeitsmeth. (Abderhalden, E.) Berl, 1937, Abt. 5, T. 6, 1. Halfte. See also Schmitt-Auracher, A. Carl von Hess zum 28. Juni 1924. 46p. portr. 8? Munch, 1924. HESS, Emil, 1911- *Beeinflussung von Infektions- und Immunitatsvorgangen durch neurovegetative Gifte. 54p. 22}^cm. Ziir., J. Hagmann, 1939. HESS, Ernst. Die Sterilitat des Rindes; ihre Erkennung und Behandlung. 2. Aufl. 176p. 36 illust. 8? Hannover, M. & H. Schaper, 1921. HESS, Ernst, 1900- *Ueber Torsion des Netzes [Kiel] 23p. 8? Lpz., B. G. Teubner, 1927. HESS, Erwin Olaf, 1900- ♦Gewerbliche Intoxikationen und Schadigungen unter spezi- fischer Berucksichtigung ihrer Symptome in der Mundhohle und an den Zahnen [Heidelberg] 31 p. 8? Ludwigshafen, Gebr. Neubauer [1930] HESS, Fritz, 1900- ♦Die Brauchbarkeit der Ballungsreaktion nach R. Muller zur sero- logischen Luesdiagnostik. 35p. 8? Bonn, P. Kubens, 1928. HESS, Hanns, 1907- ♦Die Bedeutung der ausseren Beckenmasse fiir die Diagnose des engen Beckens. 51p. 8? Wiirzb., R. Mayr, 1932. HESS, Heinrich, 1908- ♦Ueber die Frage der Fruchtschadigung durch Bestrahlung wahrend der Schwangerschaft. 25p. 8? Miinch. IT. Handl, 1935, HESS 632 HESS HESS, H[elmut] Hfermann] 1912- *Ueber die innere Organisation eines Thorakopagen mit besonderer Berucksichtigung des Herzbe- fundes [Wurzburg] 23p. 4 pl. 23cm. Berl., R. Pfau, 1937. HESS, Hermann, 1898- ♦Die post- operativen Thrombosen und Embolien an der chirurgischen Abteilung der Kranken- und Diakonissenanstalt Xeumunster-Ziirich in den Jahren 1910-30 [Zurich] 24p. 8? Basel, B. Schwabe, 1933. Also Schweiz. med. Wschr, 1934, 64: HESS, Julius Hays, 1876- Feeding and the nutritional disorders in infancy and child- hood. 5. ed. xiv, 566p. 8? Phila., F. A. Davis co., 1927. Also 6. ed. xiv, 566p. pl. 1928. ---- The premature infant, its care and development, p. 1. 30p. illust. 23^cm. [Co- lumbus, O., W. P. Simpson co., 1937] For portrait, photograph, see Collection in library. ----& LUNDEEN, Evelyn C. The premature infant; its medical and nursing care, xii, 309p. incl. illust. tab. diagr. form. 21cm. Phila., J. B. Lippincott co. [1941] HESS, Julius Hays, MOHR, George Joseph, & BARTELME, Phyllis Frances. The physical and mental growth of prematurely born children. xxiii, 449p. illust. diagrs. 8° Chic, Univ. Chicago press [1934] HESS, Katherine Paddock. Blankets, sheets, and towels for the home. 31p. 8? Manhattan, 1938. Forms Bull. 281, Kansas Agr. Exp. Sta. HESS, Kurt Giinter, 1909- *Lingua nigra [Freiburg] 18p. 8? Quakenbruck, C. Trute, 1933. HESS [Kuril Helmut, 1906- ♦Thrombo- penie und Milzexstirpation [Freiburg] 20p. 8? Charlottenb., Gebr. Hoffmann, 1929. HESS, Ludwig, 1913- ♦Selbstmord und Selbstmordverletzungen. 42p. 21^cm. Miinch., Boeck, 1938. HESS, Martin, 1910- ♦Der Nahrwert malzreicher Bioro. p. 10-32. 8? Jena [n. pub.] 1935. See also Kionka, H, & Hess, Martin. Pharmakologische Beitrage zur Alkoholfrage. H. 7: Bier als Nahrstoffspender. 32p. 8! Jena, 1935. HESS, Moise, 1907- ♦Donnees rScentes sur le traitement des helminthiases. 55p. 8? Strasb., Impr. Bourse, 1933. HESS, Paul, 1901- ♦Ueber die diag- nostischen Irrtumer bei Fruhdiagnose der Knochen- und Gelenktuberkulose [Heidelberg] 24p. 8? Rheirie, A. von Kopczynski, 1925. HESS, Ralph H. See Ely, Richard T, & Hess. Ralph H. Outlines of eco- nomics. 6. ed. 1064p. 8! N. Y, 1937. HESS, Rudolf, 1913- ♦Untersuchungen iiber das Ursprungscebiet des primaren Atmungs- ihvthmus. p.259-S2; 1 1. 22^cm. Zur., 1939. Also Arch. ges. Physiol, 1939-40, 243: HESS, Walter, 1904- ♦Ein Fall von Ovarialgraviditat [Munchen] 23p. 8? Schram- berg, Gatzer & Hahn, 1927. HESS, Walter, 1905- ♦Die Einwirkung der Schwermetalle auf Pflanzen. 24p. 8° Wiirzb., K. Triltsch, 1930. HESS, Walter, 1913- *Ein Beitrag zur Frage der Leberveranderungen bei der Base- dowschen Krankheit. 31p. 21cm. Tiib., C Guide, 1938. HESS, W[alter] C[ohen] 1899- See Sullivan, M. X, & Hess, W. C. Studies on the bio- chemistry of sulphur; the cystine content of meat and fish 13p. S5 Wash, 1931. HESS, Walter Josef, 1902- ♦Die bei der Schweizei ischen Unfallversicherungs-Anstalt Lu- zern angcmeldcten Oberschenkelschai t-Frakturen der Jahre 1924, 1925, 1926 (305 Falle) 55p. S? Ziir., Gebr. Leemann & co., 1930. HESS, Walter Rudolf, 1SS1- Die Zweek- massigkeit imBlutkreis!auf;akademische Antritts- vorlesung gehalten am 15. Juni 1918. 31 p. 4 illust. 8? Basel, B. Schwabe & co., 1918. ---- Die Regulierung des Blutkreislaufcs; gleichzeitig ein Beitrag zur Physiologie des vegetativen Nervensystemes. 162p. S° Lpz., G. Thieme, 1930. ---- Die Regulierung der Atmung; gleich- zeitig ein Beitrag zur Physiologie des vegeta- tiven Nervensystems. 137p. 8? Lpz., G. Thieme, 1931. ----Die Methodik der lokalisierten Reizung und Ausschaltung subkortikaler Hirnabschnitte. 122p. illust. pl. diagrs. 4? Lpz., G. Thieme, 1932. ----Das Zwischenhirn und die Regulation von Kreislauf und Atmung. 4 p. 1. 127p. diagr. 31cm. Lpz., G. Thieme, 1938. T. 2, Beitr. Physiol. Hirnstammes. For Festschrift see Schweiz. med. Wschr, 1941. 71: No. 11- 12, 237-456, portr. HESS, Werner, 1907- *Der Organstoff- wechsel bei der aseptischen Entzundung [Frank- furt] p.89-125. 8? Munch., J. F. Bergmann, 1931. Also Frankf. Zschr. Path, 1931, 42: HESS, Wilhelm, 1908- ♦Modellversuche uber den Verlauf der Potentiallinien des Herzens im transversalen Brustkorbquerschnitt. p.433 9. 8? Giessen, Steinkopff, 1936. Also Zschr. Kreislaufforsch, 1935, 27: HESSBRUEGGE, Wilhelm, 1908 ♦Ue- ber die Wirkung einzelner hypertonischer Ldsun- gen [Munster] lOp. 8? Bottrop, W. Postberg, 1935. HESSBRUEGGEN, Theodor, 1901- ♦Orientierende Versuche iiber die Giftigkeit der drei technisch wichtigsten Chlortoluidine [Wurz- burg] 16p. 8? Borna, R. Noske, 1928. HESSE, Alfons, 1906- ♦Zur Klinik der Lungentumoren. 36p. 8? Wiirzb., G. Grasser, 1931. HESSE, Aloys, 1901- ♦Jodausscheidung nach Eingabe von Jodostarin. 15p. 8? Giessen, A. Klein, 1927. HESSE, Bernard [Josef Heinrich Hubert] 1908- ♦Ueber den Einfluss des Xeben- nierenrindenextraktes auf Blutdruck, Blutzusam- mensetzung und Stoffwechsel (Blutzucker und Cholesterin) [Berlin] 24p. 8? Bochum, H. Poppinghaus, 1934. HESSE, Erich, & BRUCKMEYER, F. Ret- tungs- und Krankenbeforderungswesen. 248p. 8? Berl., C. Heymann, 1937. Forms Bd 7. Handb. off. Gesundhdienst. (A. E.Giitt & Moebius) HESSE, E[rich] 1883- , GIRGOLAV, S. S., & SHAAK, V. A. OiuhSkh, onacHocTH n HenpeflBHjreHHbie ocjiojKHeHna npn jieieHHH xnpyprHHecKHx 3a6ojieBanHH. Tom I. 4 p. 1. 544p. illust. 26cm. Leningr., State Pub. Biol. & Med. Liter., 1936. HESSE, Friedrich, 1907- ♦Die Beob- achtungsreihe von 92 Fallen von Haut- und Sehleimhautveranderungen bei Leukaemie an der Universitatshautkhnik Berlin in den Jahren 1920-35 [Berlin] 37p. 8? Wurzb., R. Mayr, 1935. HESSE 633 HESSEL HESSE, Fritz. ♦Massenuntersuchungen an Volksschulkindern eines Teiles des Kreises Schleswig, beziehungsweise an Kindern der hoheren Schulen der Stadt Schleswig. 3p. 8? Kiel, Schmidt & Klaunig, 1921. HESSE, Fritz, 1897- , LENDLE, Ludwig, & SCHOEN, Rudolf. Allgemeinnarkose und ort- liche Betiiubung; zusammenfassende Darstellung fiir die Praxis auf pharmakologischer und kli- nischer Grundlage. xii, 307p. illust. diagrs. 8? Lpz., J. A. Barth, 1934. HESSE, Fritz [Friedrich Wilhelm] 1910- ♦Ueber Weichteilsarkome und ihre Prognose unter Berucksichtigung ihrer Natur und Be- handlung [Wurzburg] 20p. 8? Greifsw., E. Panzig & co., 1934. HESSE, Hans, 1900- ♦Ueber Herz- beutelverwachsungen und ihre operative Be- handlung. 46p. 8? Berl., E. Ebering, 1928. HESSE, Hans, 1901- ♦Ueber die Wirkung von Methylglykolacetat bei der Einatmung. 22p. 8° Wiirzb., Werkbunddr., 1932. HESSE, Hans, 1909- ♦Zahne und Kiefer des Menschen im Lichte der anthropologischen For'schung. 44p. 8? Wiirzb., R. Mayr, 1933. HESSE, Hermann, 1877- Kurgast; Auf- zeichnungen von einer Badener Kur. 4 p. 1. 160p. 12? Berl., S. Fischer [1925] HESSE, Jean, 1904- ♦Contribution a l'etude des troubles nerveux de la lepre. 168p. 8? Par., Jouve & cie, 1934. HESSE, Josef, 1913- ♦Zahnerkrankun- gen bei Hilfsschulern der Stadt Gelsenkirchen unter besonderer Berucksichtigung der sozialen Verhaltnisse [Bonn] 24p. 21cm. Bottrop, W. Postberg, 1938. HESSE, Kathe, 1897- ♦Ueber die Be- deutung des Zuckerreizes und der Zucker- resorption fiir das Zustandekommen der ali- mentaren Hyperglykamie. 18p. 8? Berl., J. Springer, 1926. Also Zschr. ges. exp. Med, 1927, 54: HESSE, Lise, 1911- ♦Erbhygienische Untersuchungen an Hilfsschulkindern der Stiidte Oldenburg und Delmenhorst [Munster] 22p. 23cm. Delmenhorst, S. Rieck, 1938. HESSE, Martin, 1906- ♦Die Entstehung des Divertikels mit besonderer Berucksichtigung des cardianahen Magendivertikels. 24p. 8" Bonn, A. Brand, 1936. HESSE, Richard, 1868- Tiergeographie auf okologischer Grundlage; Alfred Hettner, in Freundschaft gewidmet. xii, 613p. 8? Jena, G. Fischer, 1924. For Festschrift see Zool. Jahrb, Abt. allg. Zool, 1928, 45: portr. Also editor of Index der deutschen und auslandischen zahn- arztlichen Literatur und zahnarztlichen Bibliographie. 8v. 8° Miinch, 1933-36. HESSE, Rudolf, 1909- ♦Ueber einen Atmungskorper im bestrahlten Eiweiss [Greifs- vvald] 19p. 8? Binz, A. Hesse, 1934. HESSE, Rudolf, 1913- ♦Die Schul- zahnpflege von ihren Anfiingen bis heute [Miin- chen] 28p. 20^cm. Menden, W. Riedel, 1936. HESSE, Theobald [Adalbert Helmut] 1908- ♦Grosse. Gewicht und Korperbauindex der mannlichen Bevolkerung Deutschlands [Leipzig] 28p. 8? Zeulenroda, A. Oberreuter, 1933. HESSE, Walter, 1908- ♦Thrombose nach Milzexstirpation [Jena] 33p. 8? Bautzen, E. E. Bernhardt, 1933. HESSE, Yvonne, 1901- ♦La granulie pulmonaire, occulte et froide dans la grande enfance. 94p. 2 pl. 8? Par., A. Legrand, 1930. HESSEL, Felix, 1910- ♦Die Veranderung der Scillarenempfindlichkeit durch Insulin im intermediaren Stoffwechsel [Munster] 15p. 21cm. Werne a. d. Lippe, F. Grube, 1936. HESSEL, Frederick Adam, HESSEL, Mary Stanley Hinrichs, & MARTIN, Wellford. Chem- istry in warfare, its strategic importance, x, 164p. illust. diagr. 22cm. N. Y., Hastings House [1940] HESSEL, Gerhard, 1911- ♦Die Indika- tion und Kontraindikation von Wurzelstiften und die gebrauchlichsten Verfahren ihrer Ver- ankerung [Leipzig] 32p. 8? Dahlen-S., P. Irrgang, 1935. HESSEL, Mary Stanley Hinrichs, See Hessell, F. A, Hessel, M. S. H, & Martin, W. Chem- istry in warfare. 164p. 22cm. N. Y, 1940. HESSELBARTH, Wolfgang, 1911- ♦Zur Kenntnis der Endometritis chronica und Pyo- metra der Hiindin. 43p. 2 pl. 8? Lpz., A. Edelmann, 1937. HESSELING, Lisbeth, 1913- ♦Ueber die bakteriziden Eigenschaften handelsublicher Arse- nikpraparate in Verbindung mit einem Desinfek- tionsmittel. 24p. 20>'2cm. Bonn, A. Brand, 1938. HESSELMANN, Johannes. ♦Der Einfluss des Sympathikus auf den Gradienten der Permea- bilitat der Kapillaren [Freiburg] p.287-93. pl. 8? Miinch., J. F. Lehmann [1932] Also Zschr. Biol, 1932, 92: HESSEMANN, Gustave, 1907- ♦Sur la medecine legale des traumatismes de la region frontale. 43p. 8? Strasb., Argentoratum, 1935. HESSEY, James Dodson, 1867- Colour in the treatment of disease. 79p. 16? Lond., Rider & co. [192-] HESSING, Friederich von, 1838-1918. Hessing, G. Friedrich von Hessing und seine Bedeutung fiir die deutsche Orthopadie. Hippokrates, Stuttg, 1938, 9: 616-20, portr.—Pitzen, P. Zum 100. Geburtstag des Hofrats Friedrich von Hessing; seine Verdienste um die Orthopadie und seine Stellung zur Aerzteschaft. Zschr. Orthop, 1938-39, 69: 116-27, portr. HESSLER, Fritz, 1908- ♦Zur Indikation und Kavitatenpraparation von Fullungen aus Neo-Eldentog, hochsaurebestandig auf Grund klinischer Priifungen. 15p. 8? Lpz. [n. pub.] 1932. HESSLER, Hans, 1913- ♦Zur Klinik des intradentalen Granuloma. 16p. 22^cm. Wiirzb., G. Grasser. 1938. HESSLER, Margaret Constance, 1892- ♦Experiments upon the quantitative differentia- tion of vitamins A and D. 39p. 8? N. Y. [n. pub.] 1926. HESSLER, Ottmar, 1910- ♦Zange am Steiss. 44p. 8? Wiirzb., R. Mayr, 1935. HESSMANN, A[rthur] 1879- See Schmidt, H. E. Rontgentherapie [&c] 299p. 8? Berl, 1923. HESS-THAYSEN. Thorvald Einar, 1883-1936. Gram, H. C. [Obituary] Ugeskr. laeger, 1936, 98: 402. HESTAND, David Mal, 1887- Cancer; its cause, its cure. 56p. illust. portr. 8°. Houston, Tex., Hestand Clinic, 1934. HESTERBRINK-LINDENBAUM, Bernhard, 1900- ♦Zur Vererbungs- und Konstitutions- pathologie der multiplen Exostosen. 25p. 8" [Gott., n. pub.] 1926. HESTERMAN, Coenraad, 1857-1937. Wilde, P. A. de [Obituary] Ned. tschr. geneesk, 1937, 81: 2547, portr. HETERAKIDAE. See also Fowl, Parasites; Nematoda. Cavalcanti Proenca, M. Sobre um novo typo de Heterakmae Railliet & Henry, 1912, Nematoda: Subuluroidca. In Livr. HETERAKIDAE 634 HETERODERA Jub. Prof. Travassos, Rio, 1938, 419, pl—Chitwood. B. G, & Chitwood, M. B. The histology of ncmic esophagi; the esopha- gi^ cf Heterakis jimMinae. Zschr. Zbllforsch, 1934-35, 22: 38-46. Clapham, P. \. Some observations on the effect of diei:ir\ deficiencv on infestation of chickens with th'' nematode Heterakis callinae. .1 Helminth.. S. Albans, 1934, 12: 123-C- Claussen. I, Leber Spulwurminvasion (Heterakili:i-i~> bei Hiihnern. Deut. tierarztl. W -< In. 1934.42:17-20. Dorman, IL P. Studies on the life o\ <■!.■ Heterakis papulosa Bloch) Tr. Am. Micr. Soc, 1928, 47: 379 413, pl.- Lombardo Pelle- k'rino, P. A propositi© di un Ib't'-iaki- inflexa ineln^i m un uovo di polio. Ann. igiene ly27 37: LIS .31. MrCullorh. E. • ', & Nicholson, L. <;. Phenothia/.one for the removal of Heterakis eallinae from chickens. Vet. Med, Chic, 1940, 35: 398-400- Morgan. I). O, & Wilson, J. E. The occurrence of Heterakis nallinne in poultry and its relation to disease, breed, and to otli.r helminths. I. Helminth, S. Albans, 1939, 17: 177-82.—Roberts. F. H. S. Studies on the life history and economic importance of Heterakis gallinae (Gmelin, 1790, Freeborn, 1923) the caecum worm of .fowls. Austral. J. Exp. Biol, 1937, 15: 420-39--Schwartz, B. Intestinal nodules in chickens due to heterakid larvae (Heterakis beramporia Lane) Philippine J. Sc, 102.") 28: 1-8, pl.—Smith, T., & Graybill, H. W. Blackhead in ehii kens and its experimental production bv feeding embrvonated eggs of Heterakis papiJlosa. J. Exp. M, 1920, 32: 143-52.—Van den Branden. Au sujet de l'Hete- rakis marina, ascaride se trouvant dans le tube digestif des gadid£s et pleuronectidfs, cabillaud, sole, etc, ainsi que des tortues de nicr. Arch. mid. sociale, Brux, 1939, 2: 292.— Winfield. G. F. Quantitative experimental studies on the rat rrematode Het'-rakis spumosa, Schneider, 1866. Am. J. Hyg, 1933, 17: 108-228. HETERECHINOSTOMUM. See Echinostomidae. HETEROCHROMIA. See under Iris. HETEROCONTAE. See Algae. HETERODERA. See also Anguillulidae; Eelworm; nematoda; Plant, Parasite. Newhall, A. G. Control of root-knot nema- tode in green-houses. 60p. 8? Wooster, Ohio, 1930. Alcaraz, It. A. Huevos de Heterodera radicicola, oxiurus (!) incognita, en ias materias fecales. Rev. san. mil, B. Air, 1937, 36-: 837-9.—Archetli, A. Parasitologia ■ Oxyurus incognita (Heterodera radicicola) An. Centro tisiol, B. Air, 1936, 421-31.—Barigalupo, J. Presencia de huevos de Heterodera radicicola (Oxiurus incognita) en las materias fecales humanas. Sem. mid., B. Air, 1930. 43: 412-4.—Bass, E. A consideration of some of the intestinal parasites, with a report of 3 cases of Oxyuris incognita infestation. N. Orlpans M. & S. J, 1928-29, 81: 342-50.—Baunacke, W. Untersuchungen zur Biologie und Bekampfung des Riibennematoden Heterodera schachtii Schmidt. Arb. Biol. Reichsanst, 1922-23, 11: 185-288 — Burnell, G. H. Oxyuris incocrnita in Australia. Med. J. Australia, 1921, 2: 374.—Christie, J. R, & Cobb, G. S. Notes on the life history of the root-knot nematode, Heterodera marioni. Proc. Helminth. Soc. Washington, 1941, 8: 23-6.— Cobb, N. A. Citrus root nematode. J. Agr. Res, 1914, 2: 217-30.—Ficbt, G. A. Two years of study of the effects of root nematode on the yield of canning tomatoes. J. Econom. Entom, 1938, 31: 497-506.—Frankliji, M. T. On the structure of the cyst wall of Heterodera schachtii (Schmidt) J. Helminth, S. Albans, 1030, 17: 127-34, pl. ------ On the identification of strains ol Heterodera schachtii. Ibid, 1940, 18: 63-84.— Godfrey. (.. H. Experiments on the control of the root-knot nematode in the field with chloropicrin and other ehemicals. Phytopathology, 1935, 25: 67-90. —----& Oliveira, J. The development of the root-knot nematode in relation to root tissues of pineapple and cowpea. Ibid, 1932, 22: 325-48.—- Goffart, H. Rassenstudien an Heterodera schachtii Schm.; Untersuchungen am Hafernematoden Heterodera schachtii Schm. unter besonderer Berucksichtigung des schieswig- holsteinischeu Verhaltni=se. Arb. Biol. Reichsanst, 1932, 20: 1-26. ------ Ueber die Biologie und Bekampfung des Kartoffelnematoden (Heterodera schachtii Schmidt) Ibid , 1934, 21: 7* ■ 108, 2 pl.------Beobachtungen an Heterodera marioni (Conm 1879) Godey 1932 unter besonderer Beriick- sichtigung ilires parasitologischen Vgrhaltens. Zschr. Parasi- tenk.. 1934-35. 7: 01-70.-----r Heterodera schachtii Schmidt an gemeiner Hanfnessel (Galeopsis tetrahit L.) und Kakteen. Ibid, 1935-36. 8: 528-32. ------ Zur Lebens- gesehiehie \on Heterodera schachtii maior (Nematodes) Zbl. Bakt, 2. Abt, 1938-39, 99: 394-9.—Goodey, T. On the nomenclature of the root-pall nematodes. .1. Helminth, Lond, 1932. 10: 2! s. -Harrison, A. L, & Young, P. A. Effect of root-knot nematode on tomato wilt. Phytopathology, 1941, 31:719-52- Hurst. R. H, ATrimU, M. J. Calcium cvanamidc and other artificial fertilisers in the treatment, of soil infeeted with Heterodera schachtii. .1. Helminth, Lond, 1935, 1.1: 201-18, pl.------Fin ther experiments on the chemical treatment of soil infected with Heterodera schachtii. Ibid, 1937, 15: 1-8.- -Kalinenko, V. (). [Root maeeration disease of Tau-Snjjliys] Mikrobiologia, Moskva, 1031, 3: 409-16.— Keller, A. E. The occurrence of eggs of Heterodera radicicola in human feces. J. Lab. Clin. M, 1934-35, 20: .300 2.— Schaffnit, E„ & Weber, H Versuche zur Bekampfung den W'urzeliilehens (Heterodera radicicola) Anz, Schfldlingsk, 1929. 5: 17-20.--Sengbusch. R. von. Beitrag zur Biologie des Lubenneuiatoden Heterodera schachtii; das Eindringen von Hotetodera schachtii in die Wirtswurzel, das Wandorn in dersclhen. ihre Ernahrung, Bej'titf ting, Lebensdauer der Mannchcn (Poly- oder Monogamie) Sominorwcibchen und Dauercysten und (leschlechtsverhaltnis. Zschr. Pflanzenkr, 1927, 37: 86-102.—Smith, A. M. Investigations on Heterodera schachtii in Lancashire and Cheshire; the relationships between degree of infestation and hygroscopic moisture, loss on ignition and pH value of the soil. Ann. Appl. Biol, Lond, 1929, 16: 340-6. ------ & Prentice, E. G. Investigation on Heterodera schachtii in Lancashire and Cheshire: the infesta tion in certain areas as revealed by cyst counts; an estimation of the errors involved in the technique and a correlation with intensity of disease. Ibid, 324-39.—Triffitt. M. J. On the occurrence and significance of Heterodera schachtii infesting certain weeds. J. Helminth, Lond, 1929, 7: 21.5-22. ----- On the bionomics of Heterodera schachtii on potatoes, with special reference to the influence of mustard on the escape of the larvae from the cysts. Ibid, 1930, 8: 19-48.—Tyler. J. Egg output of the root-knot nematode. Proc. Helminth. Soc. Washington, 1938, 5: 49-54.—Watfon, J. R. Control of root- knot nematodes on Florida truck farms. .1. Leonom..Entom, 1924, 17: 225-30. HETERODOXUS. See also Mallophaga. Ward, J. W. The occurrence of Heterodoxus longitarsus Piagct, Mallophaga, Boopinae, on dogs in Mississippi. J. Parasit, Lancaster, 1941, 27: No. 6, Suppl, 30. HETEROMITA. See Monadidae. HETERONEMIDAE. See also Euglenoidida. Lackey, J. B. Studies in the life histories of Euglenida; the cytology of Entosiphon sulcatum (Duj.) Stein. Arch. Proti- stenk, 1929, 66: 175-200.— Loefer, J. B. Morphology and binary fission of Heteronema acus (Ehrbg.) Stein. Ibid, 1931, 74: 449-60, 3 pl. HETEROPHORIA. See under Strabismus. HETEROPHTHALMOS. See Iris, Heterochromia. HETEROPHYIDAE. See also Trematoda; also names of genera as Cryptocotyle; Metagonimus, &c Africa. C. M. On 2 German. Heterophyidae with notes on the variability of certain structures. Zbl. Bakt, 1. Abt, 1929, 114: 81-6.------& Garcia. E. Y. Heterophyid trematodes of man and dog in the Philippines with descriptions of 3 new species. Philippine J. Sc, 1935, 57: 253-67, 4 pl. ----- Two more new heterophyid trematodes from the Philippines, Ibid.. 443-8, pl.------& De Leon, W. Intestinal hetero- phydiasis with cardiac involvement; a contribution to the etiol- ogy of heart failure. .1. Philippine Islands M. Ass, 1935, 15: 358-01. ------■ Heterophyidiasis: ova associated with a fatal hemorrhage in the right basal ganglia of the brain. Ibid, 1936, 16: 22-6, 2 pl. ------ Heterophyidiasis: 2 more cases of heart failure associated with the presence of eggs in sclerosed valves. Ibid, 1937, 17: 605-9, pl. ------ Visceral complica- tions in intestinal heterophyidiasis of man. Bull. Nat. Res. Counc. Philippines, 1940, 25: 119.—Asada, .1. Eine neue Art Trematode des Menschen: Heterophyes katsmadai. Arch, SchifTs Tropenhyg, 1926, 30: 360-5. Balozet, L.. & Callot, J. Trematodes de Tunisie, superfamille Heteiopln oidea. Arch. Inst. Pasteur Tunis, 1939, 28: 34-03.—Cameron. T. W. M. Studies on the heterophyid trematode, Apophallus venustus (Ransom, 1920) in Canada; morphology and taxonomy. Canad. J. Res, 1936, 14: Sec. D, No. 6, 59-69, pl. ----- Studies on the heterophyid trematode Apophallus venustue (Ransom, 1920) in Canada; further hosts. Ibid, 1937, 15: 275. Also repr.—Ciurea. 1. Les vers parasites de I'homme, des mammiferes et des oiseaux provenant des poissons du Danube et de la mer Noire; trematodes, familie Heterophyidae Odhner, avec un essai de classification des trematodes cie la superfamille HETEROPHYIDAE 635 HETSCH Heterophyoidea Faust. Arch, roumain path. Par, 1933, 6: 5-134, 36 pl. ------ Recherches experimentales sur la receptivite des oiseaux domestiques k I 'infestation par les trematodes de la familie Heterophyidae Odhner. In Hommage mem. J. Cantacuzene, Par, 1934, 169-84, pl.—Faust, E. C, & Nishigori, M. A preliminary report on the life cycles of 2 new heterophyid flukes- occurring in the Sino-Japanese areas. China M'. J, 1925, 39: 914-6. ——— The life cycles of 2 new species of Heterophyidae, parasitic in mammals and birds. .!. Parasit, Urbana, 1926-27, 13: 91-128, 4 pl.—Khalil, M. The life history of a heterophyid parasite in Egypt. C. rend. Congr. internat, med. trop. hyg, 1932, 1. Congr, 137-46.— Mohammed Khalil. The discovery of the life-history of Heterophyes heterophyes in Egypt. J. Egypt, M. Ass, 1933, 16: 796. Nasr, M. On the surrounding of H. heterophyes cysts in the fish. Ibid, 1941, 24: 321-3.—Ozaki, Y, & Asada, J. A new human trematode, Heterophyes katsuradai n. sp. .1. Parasit, Urbana, 1925-26, 12: 216-8, pl.— Ransom, B. H. Synopsis of the trematode family Heterophyidae with descriptions of a new genus and 5 new species. Proc. U. S. Nat. Mus, 1920, 57: 527-73. Also repr.—Skrjabin, K. J., & Podjapolskaja, W. P. Nanophyetus schikhobalowi n. sp.; ein neuer Trematode aus dem Darm des Menschen. Zbl. Bakt, 1. Abt, 1930-31, 119: 294-7.—Stunkard, H. W., & Willey, C. H. Pathology and immunity to infection with heterophyid trematodes. Biol. Bull, 1941, 81: 279.—Travassos. L. In- formacoes sobre alguns Heterophyidae dos animaes domesticos do Brasil. Ann. Fac. med. S. Paulo, 1928, 3: 1-4, 3 pl. ------ Revisao do genero Ascocotyle Looss, 1899 (Trematoda; Heterophyidae) Mem. Inst. Oswaldo Cruz, 1930, 23: 61-79, 12 pl. ------ Neubearbeitung der Gattung Ascocotyle Looss, 1899 (Trematoda; Heterophyidae. Ibid, 80-97. ------ Contribuicoes ao conhecimento das Heterophyidae (Trematoda) Ibid, 1931, 25: 47-49, 2 pl.—Vazquez-Colet, A, & Africa, C. M. Determination of the piscine intermediate hosts of Philippine heterophyid trematodes by feeding experiments. Philippine J. Sc, 1938, 65: 293; 1939, 70: 201, 4 pl.—Witenberg, G. Studies on the trematode familv Heterophyidae. Ann. Trop. M. Parasit, Liverp, 1929-30, 23: 131-239. HETEROPODA. See also Mollusca. Bhattacharya, G. C. Heteropoda venatoria preying on a pipistrelle bat. Current. Sc, Bangalore, 1941, 10: 183.— Figge, R. Die gesehleehtsausfuhrenden Wege der Heteropoden. Zschr. wiss. Zool, 1934-35, 146: 41-76. HETEROPTERA. See Hemiptera. HETEROSIDE. See Glucoside. HETEROTRICHIDA. See under Ciliata. HETEROTROPIA. See Strabismus. HETEROXYNEMA. Teixeira de Freitas, J. F, & Lins de Almeida, J. Segunda contribuicao ao conhecimento da fauna helminthologica da Argentina: Heteroxynema wernecki n. sp. Mem. Inst. Oswaldo Cruz, 1936, 31: 185-8, 3 pl. HETH, Thomas. A manifest and apparent confutation of an astrological discourse. 41 1. 32? [London] Robert Walde-Grave, 1583. HETHERINGTON, Clark W[ilson] School program in physical education; prepared as a subcommittee report to the Commission on Revi- sion of Elementary Education, N. E. A. xii, 132p. 8? Lond., G. G. Harrap & co., 1922. HETHERINGTON, Duncan Charteris, 1895- Comparative studies on certain features of nematodes and their significance. 56p. 4 pl. roy. 8? Urbana, Univ. Illinois, 1923. Forms No. 2, v.8, Illinois Biol. Monogr. HETHERINGTON. Hubert Willows, 1901- , & ESHLEMAN, Fannie. Nursing in prevention and control of tuberculosis. xix,316p. incl. illust. diagr. form. pl. 21cm. N. Y., G. P. Putnam's sons [19411 HETROY, Michel, 1910- Contribution a l'etude des injections intraveineuses d'alcool [Paris] 75p. 8? Amiens, Impr. Nouvelle, 1935. HETSCH, Heinrich, 1873- Bakteriologie; Systematik, Morphologie, Biologie und Nach- vveismethoden der wichtigsten menschenpatho- genen Mikroorganismen. 4. Aufl. vii, 125p 12? Lpz., J. A. Barth, 1923. ---- Mikrobiologie und Immunitatslehre; ein Leitfaden fur Studierende und Aerzte. 443p. 8? Berl., Urban & Schwarzenberg, 1931. See also Kolle, W, & Hetsch, H. Die experimentelle Bakteriologie [&c] 7. Aufl. 2v. 1119p. 24J^cm. Berl, 1929. Also 8. Aufl. 836p. 1938. Also English transl. 7. ed. 2v. 592p, 613p. roy. 8? Lond. [1934] HETT, Francis Paget. Editor of Sibbald, Sir Robert. The memoirs of Sir Robert Sibbald. 107p. 8? Lond, 1932. HETT, Johannes, 1894- Morphologische und experimentelle Untersuchungen am Eier- stock. p.679-778. 8? BerL, Urban & Schwar- zenberg, 1938. In Handb. biol. Arbeitsmeth. (Abderhalden, E.) Berl, 1938, 5: T. 3B„ 1. H. HETTCHE, Hans Otto, 1902- See Attz, Martin & Hettche, Hans O. Nahrboden und Farben in der Bakteriologie. 187p. 8? Berl, 1935. HETTENHAUSEN, Herbert, 1909- *Un- tersuchungen an Muskeln mit dem Sklerometer von Mangold [Leipzig] 32p. 8? Lippstadt, Thiele, 1933. HETTERICH, Josef, 1894- *Die Pneu- mokokkenperitonitis bei Erwachsenen. 24p. S? Wurzb., C. J. Becker, 1927. HETTINGA, Jabbo van, 1910- *Ueber die Kerngrossen ruhender und puerperaler Mammae. 20p. 8? Rostock, C. Hinstorff, 1935. HETTINGER, August [Karl] 1910- iden- tifizierung aus dem Gebiss [Heidelberg] 15p. 21cm. Lauda, Stieber-Druck, 1936. HETTINGER, Hans, 1902- *Das Blut- bild im Wochenbett. 52p. 8? Freib. i. B., H. M. Muth, 1926. HETTLER, Eberhard. See Erlam, D. Ranks and uniforms of the German Army, Navy and A'r Force. 159p. 22cm. Lond, 1940. HETTWER, Albert, 1899- *Schonleins ungedruckte Schrift: Von der Natur und Heilung des Keichhustens. 24p. 8? Wiirzb., J. Schacherer, 1928. HETZ, Julius, 1893- *Untersuchungen iiber den Nachweis des Bangschen Abortusbazil- lus in der Milch unter besonderer Berucksichti- gung seines Vorkommens in der Stuttgarter Marktmilch [Giessen] 4p. 8? Stuttg., W. Schumm, 1921. HETZAR, Walter, 1908- *Adoleszenten- kyphose; Bericht uber 38 Falle. 63p. 8? Konigsb. i. Pr., J. Raabe, 1933. HETZENECKER, Erwin, 1908- *Beitrag zur pathologischen Anatomie der nach Impfung auftretenden Hirnschaden. 19p. 23cm. Kiel, A. C. Ehlers, 1937. HETZER, Hildegard, 1899- Kindheit und Armut; psychologische Methoden in Ar- mutsforschung und Armutsbekampfung. 2. Aufl. viii, 182p. tab. 22^cm. Lpz., S. Hirzel, 1937. See alto Biihler, Charlotte, & Hetzer, Hildegard. Testing children's development from birth to school age; trans!, from German. 191p. 8° N. Y. [19351 HEUBACH, Hans, 1908- *Pathologiseh- klinische Betrachtung der Hypophysengeschwiil- sto mit Bekanntgabe eines eigenen Falles. 38p. 8? Bonn, A. Brand, 1935. HEUBECK, Leonhard Hermann, 1906- *Beitrage zur Histopathologie der Paralysis agitans. 24p. 8? Erlangen, Hofer & Limmert, 1935. HEUBEL HEUBEL, Otto, 1903- *Rezidive nach Trigcnunusoperationen in den letzten 10 Jahren [Heidelberg] 35p. S? Mannheim, Schmalz & Laschingor, 1929. HEUBI.EIN, Arthur C. ls7!> 1932. l.aField. \V. A. [Obituary] Am. J. Roentg, 1932, 27: 76 . HEUBI.EIN, friedrich, 1908- *Haeman- giomo dos Riickenmarks [Wurzburg] 39p. 21cm. C'oburg, A. Rossteutscher, 1935. HEUBLEIN, Werner, 1909- *Die arzt- lichen Aufgaben bei Massenvergiftungen durch Gase' [Wurzburg] 36p. 8? Bamb., J. Xagen- gast, 1936. HEUBNER, Otto, 1843-1926. [Autobiography] Mid. Gegenwart (Grote) Lpz, 1925, 4: 93-124, portr.— Bahrdl. Nekrolog. Miinch. med. Wschr, 1926, 73: 203i. —Bokay. J. Zur Erinnerung an Otto Heubner, Ehreiipifisidont der Deutschen Gesellschaft fiir Kinderheillunde. Wien. klin. Wschr, 1927, 40: 1481-3.— Heubner. \V. Aus Briefen Otto Heubners. Kinderarztl. Prax, 1930, 1: 138-43.— Langstein. L. Nekrolog. Zschr. Kinderh, 1926, 42: p. i-iv.------Otto Heubner als Sozial- hvgieniker. Gesundhfurs. Kindesalt, 1920-27, 2: 204-8.— Muller, K. Nekrolou. Med. KUn, Berl, 1920, 22: 1786.— [Obituaryl Am. J. Dis. Child, 1927, 33: 474. HEUBNER, Wolfgang Otto Leonhard, 1877- Arznei tils Wert; Antrittsvorlesung ge- halten zu Heidelberg am 29. November 1930. 26p. 8° Berl., J. Springer, 1931. Also editor of Handbuch der experimentellen Pharmakologie. Berl, supplement Nos. 1-5, 1935-37. - KRAUTWALD, A. [et al.] Arzneiver- ordnungen; Ratschlage fiir Studenten und Aerzte. Ausgabe 1938. 241 p. le'/.cm. Lpz., S. Hirzel [1937] HEUCK, Annaliese, 1903- *Ueber die Mikrosporie in Hamburg [Kiel] 20p. 8? Hamb., .1. D. Hollmann, 1932. HEUCK. Hans, 1912 *Zur Frage der Bauchdeckendesmoide, unter Berucksichtigung eines eigenen Falles von aussergewohnlichen Ausmassen | Munchen] 31 p. 21cm. Speyer, Pilger, 1938. HEUCK, Jutta, 1908- *Foetus papyraceus sive compressus [Heidelberg] lip. 8? Bruch- sal, J. Kruse & Sohne, 1935. HEULKE, Ruth, 1911- *Zur Kenntnis des Streptococcus lactis unter besonderer Be- riicksichtigung der Malzaroma-Stamme; Auf- spaltung in stark und schwach sauernde Stamme [Kiel] 62p. 8? Quakenbruck, R. Kleinert, 1935. HEUCKENKAMP, Gisbert, 1904- *Die Devitalisation der Pulpa [Tubingen] 31p. 8? Zeulenroda, B. Sporn, 1935. HEUEL, Josef, 1895- *Ueber die Ge- schichte der Diabetestherapie. 61 p. 8? Bonn, P. Kubens, 1929. HEUER, Franz, 1910- *Der Ovulations- termin bei der vierwochentlichen Regelblutung [Kiel] 2Sp. 8? Gutersloh, Thiele, 1935. HEUER, Friedrich [August Julius] 1893- *Ueber Pseudosprache mit einem Fall von jtimmhafter Mundsprache. 16p. 8? Berl., E. Kbering, 1925. HEUER, Fritz, 1903- *Ueber Ganglio- neurome der Xebenniere [Berlin] 32p. 8° Charlottenb., Gebr. Hoffmann, 1932. HEUER, Hans. *Ein ungewohnlicher Fall von Chininexanthem [Gottingen] 19p. 8? Hameln, C. W. Xiemever, 1930. HEUER, Heinz Erich, 1913- *Ueber die sogenannten Seminome des Hodens und ihren klinischen Verlauf [Halle] 36p. 21cm. Blei- cherode, C. Xieft, 1937. HEUER, Roswitha [Berta Gertrud] 1910- *Zur Kombination von Ichthyosis und Psoriasis. 25p. V Marburg-L., H. Bauer, 1934. HEUER HEUER, Werner, 1904- *Ueber die Erfahrungen mit der Kiellandzange an der Wiirz burger Universitiitsfrauen klinik [Wiirz- burg| 2Sp. 8? Kirchhain, J. Schroder, 1927. HEUER [Wilhelm Hermann] Otto, 1910- *I)as haptische Gleich-hoch und Gleich-woit [Jena] 28p. 8? Zeulenroda, B. Sporn, U135. HEUEVELDOP, Rudolf, 1907- *Dcr Arzt im Strafvollzug in Stolen. 32p. 22^cm. Miinst. i. W., Regensberg, 1933. HEUING, Paula, 1912- *Erbhygienischc Untersuchungen an Fiirsorgezoglingen der Pro- vinzial-Fiirsorgeanstalt Josephshaus Wettringen [Munster] 19p. 21cm. Werne a. d. Lippe, F. Grube, 1936. HEUKAMP, Anna, 1899- *Die vaghsale Totalexstirpation an der Gottinger Universitats- Frauenklinik von 1914-24 mit besonderer Be- riicksichtigung der Xebenverletzungen [Gottin- gen] 24p. 8? Wiirzb., F. Schwarz, 1925. HEULER, Ludwig, 1912- *Ueber die Behandlung Herzkranker mit Folinerin. 18p. 21cm. Wiirzb., C. J. Becker, 1938. HEUMANN, Paul Gunther, 1906- *Am- moniakbestimmung im Harn von Nierenkranken [Frankfurt] 22p. 8? Wertheim, E. Bechstein, 1933 HEUMANN, Wilhelm, 1912- *Ein Gift- mord durch Thallium [Wurzburg] 18p. 21cm. Miinch., F. X. Seitz, 1937. HEUMUELLER, Karl A., 1913- *Ery- throcytengrosse bei verschiedenen Krankheiten [Frankfurt] 20p. 8? Gelnhausen, F. W. Kalbfleisch, 1936. HEUN, Martin, 1903- *Die medizinische Zeitschriftenliteratur der Romantik. 157p. 8? Lpz. [n. pub.] 1931. HEUN, Theodor, 1905- *Zur Kenntnis der Tuberkulose des Magens. 30p. 8? Bonn, Carthaus, 1929. HEUNER, Wolfgang, 1909- *Die Rolle der Blutung bei der Magengeschwiirskrankheit [Bonn] 51p. 8? Wurzb., R. Mayr, 1937. HEUNET, Jean, 1905- *Le rhumatisme chronique deformant; complication de la dilata- tion des bronches [Paris] 44p. 2 pl. 8? Charleville, Impr. Modern., 1932. HEUNISCH, August, 1906- *Die Sterb- lichkeit an Cholera [Munchen] 19p. 8? Regensb., G. Aumuller & Sohn, 1930. HEUPEL, Friedrich Anton, 1899- *Tra- chealstenose bei Lupus [Wurzburg] 14p. 8? Attendorn, Anker, 1926. HEUPEL, Karl Heinz, 1909- *Ueber spontanen Zahnausfall. 24p. 22',cm. Marb., J. A. Koch, 1936. HEUPKE, Wilhelm, 1898- Diatetik; die Ernahrung des Gesunden und des Kranken. xi, 192p. tab. 8? Dresd., T. Steinkopff, 1936. Forms Bd 20, Med. Praxis (Grote, L. R. [et al.]) ---- Die Faeces des Menschen; funktionelle Diagnostik der Darmkrankheiten, Physiologie und Pathophysiologie der Verdauungsvorgange. xi, 115p. illust, 4 pl. 23cm. Dresd., T. Steinkopff, 1939. Forms Bd 28, Med. Praxis (Grote, L. R. [et al.]) HEURES a l'usage de Rome. 78 1. sm. 4? Paris, Philippe Pigouchet for Simon Vostre [1501] HEUSCH, Paul, 1907- *Ueber den Ein- fluss der Zubereitung der menschlichen Nahrung mit Hilfe des Feuers auf ihren ernahrungsphysio- logischen Wert [Berlin] 15p. 21cm. Gorlitz, Hoffman & Reiber, 1937. HEUSCHEN 637 HEUSSI HEUSCHEN [Johann] Josef [Hubert] 1907- *Ueber die Behaarung Geisteskranker. 23p. 8? Bonn, P. Kubens, 1934. HEUSCHERT, Carl August, 1898- *Blut- mengenuntersuchungen bei kochsalzfreier Kost und Magensaftentziehung. 19p. 8? Greifsw., H. Adler, 1935. HEUSER, Carlos, 1878-1934. Case, J. T. [Obituary] Am. J. Roentg, 1934, 32: 242. Also Radiology, St Paul, 1934, 23: 245.—Korder, A. Nekrolog. Fortsch. Roentgenstrahl, 1934, 50: 186. HEUSER, Emil, 1882- Carbohydrates. Ill: Cellulose, p. 1534-94. 23^cm. X. Y., J. Wiley & sons, 1938. In Organic chem. (Gilman, H.) v.2. HEUSER, Gustav. Prosopographie vonAegyp- ten. IV: Die Kopten. 3 p. 1. 48p. 28cm. Heidelb., F. Bilabel, 1938. Forms Bd 2, Hilfsb. Quellen & Stud. Gesch. Kultur d. Altert. & Mittelalt. (Reihe, C) HEUSER, G[ustave] Frederick] 1893- , & ANDREWS, F. E. Weight changes in chickens. 20p. 8? Ithaca, N. Y., 1932. Forms No. 240, Cornell Extens. Bull. HEUSER, Hans, 1907- *Ueber Zahn- liickenbuchten der Oberkieferhohle. 26p. 5 pl. 22cm. Marb., R. Friedrich, 1934. --- Die normale und kranke Alveolarbucht im Rontgenbild. 79p. 8? Lpz., H. Meusser, 1938. Forms H. 34, Abh. klin. Zahnh. HEUSER, Hans, 1910- *Intrakranielle Blutungen nach Schadeltraumen ohne Frakturen der Schadelknochen (nach dem Sektionsmaterial des Gerichtlich-medizinischen Institutes zu Miin- chen) [Munchen] 40p. 21cm. Bottrop, W. Postberg, 1936. HEUSER, Otto, 1908- *Ueber Kompli- kationen bei Verletzungen der Speiserohre. 43p. 8? Freib. i. B., H. Fiirderer, 1936. HEUSER [Paul] Josef, 1889- *Angiom der Hypophyse bei Adipositas hypogenitalis [Frankfurt] 46p. 8? Heidelb., W. Klohe & C. Silber, 1917. HEUSINGER, Carl Friedrich von, 1906- *Experimentelle Untersuchungen zum Nachweis psychischer Einfliisse auf die Nierenfunktion speziell auf die Diurese. 36p. ch. 8? Marb., K. Euker, 1933. HEUSS, Ernst. *Beitrag zur Kenntnis der Atrophia maculosa cutis [Zurich] 43p. 8? Hamb., L. Voss, 1901. HEUSS, Eugen. Rationale Biologie und ihre Kritik (eine Auseinandersetzung mit dem Vitalis- mus H. Driesch's) ix, 192p. 25cm. Lpz., S. Hirzel, 1938. H. 24r Studien und Bibliographien zur Gegenwartsphiloso- phie (W. Schingnitz) HEUSS, Gerhard Fritz, 1914- *Experi- mentelle Untersuchungen iiber die chemothera- peutische Wirkung des Wismuts auf die Strepto- kokkeninfektion der weissen Maus. 22p. 21cm. [Frankf. a. M., n. pub.] 1938. HEUSS, Karl, 1867- *Mass- und Ge- wichtsbestimmungen; iiber die morphologische Asymmetrie der Extremitiitenknochen des Pferdes und anderer Perissodaktylen; eine osteo- logische Studie [Leipzig] 63p. 8? Paderborn, F. Schoningh, 1898. HEUSSEN, Lambert, 1905- *Ueber Verkalkungen in Hirngliomen [Munster-Westf.] 30p. 21cm. Bottrop, W. Postberg, 1935. HEUSSER, Heinrich, 1894- Die Erken- nung und Behandlung des akuten Darmver- schlusses. 35p. 8? Stuttg., F. Enke, 1936. Forms 6. Heft, Vortr. prakt. Chir. (E. Lexer) HEUSSI, Martha. *Ueber Lymphogranulo- matose besonders ihr familiares Vorkommen [Basel] 30p. 22^cm. Ziir., Fluntern, 1936 HEUTHE, Erwin, 1905- *Der heutige Stand der Gaumenspaltenoperation. 43p 8° Bonn, P. Kubens, 1931. HEUTLING, Oskar, 1898- *Ueber Kiefer- und Zahnanomalien bei mongoloider Idiotie [Kiel] 14p. 8? Stassfurt, C. Trippo, 1928. HEUVEN, Gerrit Johannes van. *Experi- menteel-anatomisch onderzoek omtrent de corti- cale optische projectie bij den Java-aap. 64p. 2 1. 8? Amst., P. H. Vermeulen, 1929. HEUYER, Georges, 1884- Anthropologic psychique. 3p; p.93-132. 8? Par., J. B. Bailliere, 1929. In Trait6 d'hyg. (Martin, L. & Bouardel, G.) Par, 1929. ---- & GILBERT-ROBIN. Psychiatric p.839-954. 8? Par., 1934. In Trait6 mid. enfants (NobScourt & Babonneix) Par, 1934, 4: See also Rodiet, A, & Heuyer, G. La folie au xxe sidcle; itude mSdico-sociale. 359p. 8? Par, 1931. HEUZE, Charles Jean Baptiste, 1898- *De la bronchite vermineuse des bovins dans le Bessin [Alfort] 46p. 8? Par., Ed. Rev. Nos Animaux, 1927. HEUZE, Pierre, 1893- Contribution a l'etude de l'osteose parathyroidienne (maladie de Recklinghausen) 51 p. 16 pl. 8? Par., Le Frangois, 1933. HEVEA. See Latex; Rubber. HEVELING, Norbert, 1905- *Ein Fall von doppelseitigem Femurdefekt [Bonn] 27p. 8? Bottrop, W. Postberg, 1933. HEVELKE, Gert, 1909- *Die Pro- montoriofixur des Uterus und der Vagina bei ungewohnlich grossen und komplizierten Pro- lapsen [Berlin] 19p. 22}£cm. Wiirzb., K. Triltsch, 1936. HEVEROCH, Antonin, 1869-1927. Nayendorf, N. von. Nekrolog. Zschr. ges. Neur. Psychiat, 1927, 110: 160-2.— Syllaba, Pres. [et al.] [Obituary] Cas. lik. 6esk, 1927, 66: 449-74. HEVESY, Gyorgy, 1885- Das Ele- ment Hafnium. 2 p. 1. 49p. 8? Berl., J. Springer, 1927. ---- Chemical analysis by X-Rays and its applications. 7 p. 1. 333p. illust. pl. portr. diagrs. 8? X. Y., McGraw-Hill book co., 1932. ---- & PANETH [Fritz] A manual of radio- activity. 2. ed., completely rev. & enl., transl. by Robert W. Lawson. xvi, 306p. illust. 5 pl. diagr. 24cm. Lond., Oxford Univ. press, 1938. HEWAT [Andrew Fergus] 1884- Hewat's Examination of the urine and other clinical side-room methods; rev. & enl. by G. L. Mal- colm-Smith. 7. ed., repr. viii, 228p. illust. 12^4cm. Edinb., E. & S. Livingstone, 1932. HEWER [Annie M. nee Everard] Our baby; for mothers and nurses; rev. by Sophia Seekings Friel. 21. ed. xvi, 177p. illust. pl. tab. diagr. 19cm. Bristol, J. Wright & sons, 1930. ----The baby of today; first principles in his management. 7. ed. p. 1. 42p. 18^cm. Brist., J. Wright & sons [1939] HEWER, Christopher Langton, 1896- Recent advances in anaesthesia and analgesia. viii, 187p. 64 illust. 8? Lond, J. & A. Churchill, 1932. Also 2. ed. (including oxygen therapy) x, 284p. illust. tab. diagrs. 1937. Also 3. ed. xi, 333p. illust. 21cm. Phila., Blakiston co., 1939. HEWER HEWER, Evelyn Everard. Text-book of histology for medical students, xi, 365p. illust. tab. diagrs. roy. 8? Lond., W. Heinemann, 1937. ----& SANDES, Gladys Maud. An intro- duction to the study of the nervous system. 2 p. 1. vii-xii, 104p. 32 pl. roy. 8? Lond., W. Heinemann, 1929. Also 2. ed. xiv, 147p. illust. pl. tab. 1933. HEWER, Humphrey Robert. Practical zo- ology; instructions for dissection and preparation of elementary types of animals, p. 1. 118p. incl. diagr. 19cm. Lond., Hutchinson Sc. & Techn. Pub. [1940] See also Piney. Alfred. Recent advances in microscopy: Zoology. 260p. 8? Lond, 1931. HEWER, Joseph Langton, Mrs. See Hewer, Annie M. HEWES, Henry Fox, 1868-1926. Obituary. J. Am. M. Ass.. 1926, 87: 428. HEWETSON, John Thomas, 1872-1936. Obituary. Birmingham M. Rev, 1936, 11: 74-5, portr.— Lloyd, H. N. Obituary. Brit. M. J, 1936, 1: 1135, portr. Also J. Obst. Gyn. Brit. Empire, 1936, 43: 1196, portr. HEWETSON, W[illiam] M[orton] Environ- mental influences affecting blondes in Rhodesia and their bearing on the future. 27p. 8? Salisbury, Rhodesia Independent co., 1922. HEWETT, Edgar Lee, 1865- Ancient life in the American southwest, with an intro- duction on the general history of the American race, xvii, 392p. 31 pl. 8? Indianapolis, Bobbs-Merrill co. [1930] HEWETT, S. C. Dr S. C. Hewet, Bone- setter, successor to the late Dr Job Sweet, who died in Boston, about 9 years since; Dr H. may be found at 297 Washington Street, nearly opposite Avon Place, Boston, Mass. 16p. 8? Bost , 1860. HFWITT, Charles Nathaniel, 1836-1910. Keys, T. F, The medical books of Dr Charles N. Hewitt. Proc. Mayo Clin, 1941, 16: 732-6. HEWITT, Earl Albon, 1891- The physico- chemical basis of physiological phenomena. p. 1-15. roy. 8? [Ann Arb., Mich., 1935] In Physiology of domestic animals (Dukes) Ithaca, N. Y, 1935. See also Bergman, H. D, & Hewitt, E. A. Laboratory manual for experimental physiology. 113 numb. 1. 27lA x 23cm. Minneap, 1940. Also Dukes, Henry H, Hewitt, Earl A, & McNutt, G. W. The physiology of domestic animals. 391 p. roy. 8? [Ann Arbor, Mich, 1933] HEWITT, Sir Frederic William, 1857-1916. Bloomfield, J. Pioneers of modern anaesthesia. Brit. J. Anaesth, 1926-27, 4: 116-23, portr.—[Portrait] In Proc. Dent. Centen. Celebr. (Maryland Dent. Ass.) 1940, 350. HEWITT, James Arthur, 1889- Editor of Halliburton, W. D. Essentials of chemical physiology. 12.-13. ed. 383p.; 350p. 8! Lond, 1936-39. HEWITT, John. See Cameron, Samuel J, & Hewitt, John. Difficult labour. 305p. 8? Lond, 1926. ------ Uterine haemorrhage. 208p. 12! Lond, 1926. Also Cameron, S, Hewitt, J. [et al.] eds. A Glasgow manual of obstetrics. 3. ed. 679p. 23Hcm. Lond. [1939] HEWITT, Leslie Frank. Oxidation-reduction potentials in bacteriology and biochemistry. 70p. 8? [Lond.] London County Counc, 1931. Also 4. ed. lOlp. incl. illust. tab. diagrs. 1936. HEWITT, Redginal [Irving] Bird malaria. xii p. 2 1. xiii-xvii, 228p. illust. 13 pl. tab. diagr. 23Sem. Bait., Johns Hopkins Press, 1940. No. 15. Monogr. ser. Am. J. Hyg, July, 1940. HEWITT, Richard Miner, 1892- [Biography] Phi Chi Q, Menasha, 1935, 32: 375, portr. HEWLETT, Albion Walter, 1874-1925. Path- ological physiology of internal diseases; functional HEWLETT pathology; rev. in memoriam by his colleagues ... under the editorial supervision of George DeForest Barnett. xxxiii, 787p. 8? N. Y , D. Appleton & co. [1928] For portrait, photograph, see collection in library. HEWLETT, Richard Tanner, 1865-1940. A manual of bacteriology, clinical and applied. 8. ed. x, 645p. 38 pl. 8? Lond., J. & A. Churchill, 1926. Also 9. ed. ix, 746p. 66 illust. 43 pl. 1932. For biography see Brit. M. J, 1940, 2: 400. Also Lancet Lond, 1940, 2: 407, portr. Also Nature, Lond, 1940, 146: 552 (J. C. G. Ledingham) HEWSON, Addinell, 1855-1938. Schaeffer. J. P. Obituary. Tr. Coll. Physicians Phila- delphia, 1939, 7: 192-7. HEWSON, William, 1739-74. [Biography] Cat. Portr. R. Coll. Surgeons, Lond, 1930, 30, HEXACOTYLE. See also Trematoda. Dawes, B. Hexacotyle extensicauda, n. sp, a monogenetic trematode from the gills of the tunny, Thunnus thynnus L Parasitology, Lond, 1940, 32: 271-86. ------ Notes on the formation of the egg capsules in the monogenetic trematode, Hexacotyle extensicauda Dawes, 1940. Ibid, 287-95. HEXAMETHYLENTETRAMINE. See Methenamina (IT. S. P.) HEXAMINE. See Methenamina (U. S. P.J HEXAMITA. See also Flagellata; Monadida. Andrews, J, & Reynolds, M. Hexamita in the blood of a mouse. J. Parasit, Lancaster, 1941, 27: No. 6, Suppl, 26.— Bishop, A. The morphology and division of Hexamita gigas n. sp. (Flagellata) Parasitology, Lond, 1933, 25: 163-70, 2 pl.—Hinshaw, W. R, & McNeil, E. Carriers of Hexamita meleagridis. Am. J. Vet. Res, 1941, 2: 453-8. ------ Ex- perimental infection of chicks with Hexamita meleagridis. Cornell Vet, 1941, 31: 345-50.—Lavier, G. Sur la structure des flagelhis du genre Hexamita Duj. C. rend. Soc. biol, 1936, 121: 1177-80.—Wenrich, D. H. A species of Hexamita (Protozoa, Flagellata) from the intestine of a monkey (Macacus rhesus) J. Parasit, Urbana, 1933, 19: 225-9. HEXANE. See Hydrocarbon. HEXATYLUS. See also Nematoda. Goodey.. T. Some observations on the nematode Hexatylus viviparus Goodey, 1926. J. Helminth, S. Albans, 1938, 16: 109-16.------ Observations on 2 . free-living nematodes, Hexatylus coprophagus n. sp, and H. consobrinus (de Man, 1906) Goodey, 1932. In Livr. Jub. Prof. Travassos, Rio, 1938, 179-82, 2 pl. HEXETON. See also Cardiotonics. Bosshardt, W. *Ueber die Wirkung des Hcxetons auf das Froschherz. 32p. 8? Marb., 1926. Chiodo, A. Action combin^e du camphre et du salicylate de sodium; influence du salicylate sur Taction pharmacologique de l'hex6tone. Arch, internat. physiol, Li6ge, 192.t, 31: 89-120.—Govorov, N. P. [Hexeton and the cardio-vas ular system] Arkh. biol. nauk, 1935, 39: 227-30.—Helaers, E. Action sur la respiration de l'hexfetone dissous dans le benzoate sodique. C. rend. Soc. biol, 1926, 95: 719-22. ------ Action de l'hex6tone en solution salicyl6e sur la respiration. Ibid, 717-9.—Schenk, S. Hexeton und Infektionskrankheiten. Wien klin. Wschr, 1926, 39: 634.—Schultz. Unerwiinschte Hexetonwirkung? Deut. med. Wschr, 1928, 54: 705 — Stross, W. Untersuchungen iiber die Wirkungsweise einiger Analeplika; Hexeton. Arch. exp. Path, Lpz, 1928, 130: 349-64.—Sundermann. Erfahrungen mit Hexeton, besonders mit Hexetonperlen. Deut. med. Wschr, 1927, 53: 283. HEXONE bases. See under proper names as Arginine, &c. HEXOSAMINE 639 HEXYLRESORCINOL Polysaccharides: HEXOSAMINE. See also Glucosamine. Levene, P. A. Epimeric hexosaminic acids. J. Biol. Chem, 1918, 36: 73-87. ------ The action of nitrous acid on epimeric hexosaminic acids. Ibid, 89-94.------Methyl- ation of hexosamines. Ibid, 1941, 137: 29-39.------& Sobotka, H. Deamination of 3-aminohexoses. Ibid, 1926-27, 71: 181-5.—Palmer, J. W, Smyth, E. M, & Meyer, K. On glycoproteins; the estimation of hexosamine. Ibid, 1937, 119: 491-500.—Sideris, C. P., Young, H. Y, & Krauss, B. H. The distribution of uncombined hexosamine in pineapple plants supplied either with ammonium sulfate or calcium nitrate salts. Ibid, 1938, 126: 233-9. Also repr. HEXOSANE. See Carbohydrates, Types: 6-osanes. HEXOSE. See Carbohydrates, Types: Monasaccharides: 6-oses; also Glucose; Levulose. HEXOSE-PHOSPHORIC acid. See Carbohydrates, Types: Saccharide deriva- tives, phosphoric; also Glucuronic acid. HEXTER, George Jacob. See Farmer, L, & Hexter, G. J. What's your allergy? 234p. 21cm. N. Y, 1939. HEXURONIC acid. See Vitamin C. HEXYL alcohols. Dukelsky, B. E. [Intravenous anesthesia with hexanol] Nov. khir. arkh, 1938, 41: 3-24.—Hovorka, F, Lankelma, H. P., & Axelrod, A. E. Thermodynamic properties of the hexyl alcohols; 2-methylpentanol-e and 3-methylpentanol-3. J. Am. Chem. Soc, 1940, 62: 187-9.—Hovorka. F, Lankelma. H. P, & Bishop, J. W. Thermodynamic properties of the liexvl alcohols; 2, 3-dimethylbutanol-2 and 3-methylpentanol-2. Ibid, 1941, 63: 1097.—Hovorka, F, Lankelma, H. P, & Smith, W. R. Thermodynamic properties of the hexyl alcohols; 2, 2-dimethylbutanol-l and 2-ethylbutanol-l. Ibid, 1940, 62: 2372-4.—Lowstuter, W. R. The electrochemical oxidation of n-Hexanol. Univ. Pittsburgh Bull, 1940, 16: 195-201.— Ovakimian, G, Mardashew, S, &- Levene, P. A. Konfigura- tionsbeziehungen von Aethylcyclohexyl- und Aethylhexyl- carbinol. Biochem. Zschr, 1937, 293: 410-4. HEXYLAMINE. See Ptomaine. HEXYLRESORCINOL. See also Resorcinol. Perkelet, L. *La relation entre la tension superficielle et le pouvoir bactericide de l'hexyl- resorcine [Geneve] 24p. 22>£cm. Ziir., 1938. Also Schweiz. Mschr. Zahnh, 1938, 48: 91-114. Sanz Diaz, M. L. *Hexylresorcinol [Chile] 28p. 26cm. Santiago, 1939. Allen, A. W, & Wright, I. S. The bactericidal properties of the solution S. T. 37 (liquor hexylresorcinolis 1 : 1,000) Arch. Surg, 1928, 17: 834-9.—Brown, D. A. El hexilorresor- cinol en las infecciones urinarias: resultados en sesenta y tres casos. Gac. mid. Caracas, 1926, 33: 188-90.—Brun, G. C, & Nielsen, E. P. [On dosage of hexylresorcinol] Ugeskr. laeger, 1940, 102: 1325.—Clapham, P. A. Hexylresorcinol as a general vermicide. J. Helminth, Lond, 1932, 10: 195-8.—Daggs, R. G, Murlin, W. R, & Murlin, J. R. The effect of hexyl- resorcinol upon the absorption of insulin from the gastro- intestinal tract of dogs. Am. J. Physiol, 1937, 120: 744-9.— Eberbach, C. W., & Arn, R. D. Hexylresorcinol in urinary tract infections; therapeutic effect. J. Am. M. Ass, 1927, 89: 512-4.—Feirer, W. A, & Leonard, V. The stability of hexylresorcinol in pharmaceutical preparation. J. Pharm. Exp. Ther, 1926, 28: 395-7. ------ Hexylresorcinol in oral antisepsis, with special reference to solution S. T. 37. Dent. Cosmos, 1927, 69: 82-92. ------ The bactericidal activity of hexylresorcinol (solution S. T. 37) on wound surfaces. Surg. Gyn. Obst, 1928, 47: 488-92.—Grewal, K. S. The action of a soluble derivative of hexylresorcinol. J. Pharm. Exp. Ther, 1932, 45: 283-90.—Haury, V. C. Hexylresorcinol. In Cyclop. Med. (Piersol-Bortz) Phila, 1939, 7: 275.—Hexyl- resorcinol solution S. T. 37 omitted from N. N. R. J. Am. M. Ass, 1935, 104: 1906-8.—Horwitt. M. K, & Simon, F. P. Hexylresorcinol as an inhibitor of catalyzed reactions. J. Biol. Chem, 1941 140: Proc, 63.—Jacobsen, E. [Hexyl- resorcin] Ugeskr. laeger, 1936, 98: 1091-3.—Leonard, V., & teirer, VV. A. Hexylresorcinol as a general antiseptic. Surg. Gyn. Obst 1927, 45: 603-11. ------ The bactericidal activity of hexylresorcmol in glycerine; with special reference to the influence of surface tension in chemical disinfection. Bull. Johns Hopkins Hosp, 1927, 41: 21-35.—Maplestone, P. A, & Chopra, R. N. The effect of hexylresorcinol on cats. Ind. J. M. Res, 1934, 21: 519-21.—Osterhout, W. J. V. Lffects of hexylresorcinol on Nitella. J. Gen. Physiol, 1939-40, 23: 569-73 ------ Effects of hexylresorcinol on Valonia! Ibid, 1940-41, 24: 311-3. Also repr.—Bobbins, B. H. Quan- titative studies on the absorption and excretion of hexyl- resorcinol and heptylresorcinol under different conditions J. Pharm. Exp. Ther, 1931, 43: 325-33. —--- & Wesson, L. G. A method for the quantitative determination of hexyl- resorcinol in tissues, blood and excreta. Ibid, 335-7.— Salle, A. J., & Lazarus, A. S. Comparison of resistance of bacteria and embryonic tissue to germicidal substances- hexylresorcinol. Proc. Soc. Exp. Biol, N. Y, 1934-35 32- 1119. Also repr.—Schenck, H. P. Hexylresorcinol as a cerebrospinal antiseptic. Arch. Neur. Psychiat, Chic. 1927 18: 590-2.—Tubangui, M. A, Basaca, M, & Pasco, A. m! Hexylresorcinol as an anthelmintic; its efficiency against the intestinal parasites of man. Philippine J. Sc, 1934 54: 473- 81.—Walter. C. W. Idiosyncrasy to hexylresorcinol. J. Am. M. Ass, 1935, 104: 1897. Also repr. HEY, Annemarie, 1909- *Der Para- tonsillarabszess im Kindesalter. 20p. 23cm Greifsw., H. Adler, 1938. HEY, Gotthold, 1907- *Pocken und Rotlicht (Kritisches zu den bisher erschienenen Arbeiten nebst experimentellen Beitragen iiber Rotlichtwirkung auf das Vaccinevirus) [Rostock] 44p. 8? Berl., Gebr. Hoffmann, 1934. HEYCK, Kaethe [Theodora] 1907- * Ueber die Wirkung von Viburnum prunifolium auf den isolierten Meerschweinchenuterus [Rostock] 16p 8? Lubeck, P. Bernbeck [1931] HEYD, Eberhard, 1912- * Experimentelle Beitrage zum psycho-galvanischen Reflex-Phano- men [Munchen] 32p. 21cm. Zeulenroda, B. Sporn, 1938. HEYDE, Bernhard, 1899- *Ein Fall von Abriss des nicht graviden, gesunden Uterus an Cervix-Corpusgrenze veranlasst durch indirekte Gewalt. 27p. 8? Miinch. [n. pub.] 1929. HEYDE, Franz, 1890- *Das Material an chirurgischen Nierenerkrankungen der Wiirz- burger chirurgischen Universitatsklinik im Luit- poldkrankenhaus vom Jahre 1923-28. 30p. 8? Wiirzb., Gebr. Memminger, 1929. HEYDE, Gerhard. Das Wurttembergische Wunderbad zu Boll; ein geschichtlicher Riick- blick nach alten und neuen Quellen. 141, 2p. illust. pl. portr. 8? Stuttg., T. F. Steinkopf [1937] HEYDE, Johannes Erich, 1892- Technik des wissenschaftlichen Arbeitens; eine Anlei- tung, besonders fiir Studierende. 4. ed. viii, 151p. 8? Berl., Junker & Diinnhaupt, 1933. HEYDE, Markus, 1913- *Zur Reizung des Flimmerepithels. 23p. 21cm. Tiib., A. Becht, 1938. HEYDE, Renate, 1911- *Tumoren der Tranendriise [Tubingen] 29p. 8? Schram- berg, Gatzer & Hahn, 1937. HEYDE, Robert Wolfgang, 1902- *Fluo- reszenzmikroskopische Untersuchungen an Eryth- rozyten im Blute Neugeborener. 20p. 8? Lpz., A. Edelmann, 1937. HEYDE, Werner, 1902- *Untersuchungen uber Gehirnfermente. 44p. 8? Wiirzb., Gebr. Memminger, 1932. HEYDEMANN, Fritz, 1888- lnter- suchungen iiber den Nahrstoffbedarf und den Verlauf der Nahrstoffaufnahme bei der Tomate, unter besonderer Berucksichtigung des Ein- flusses der Kohlensaurebegasung [Kiel] p. 100- 40. 8? Berl., J. Springer, 1928. 340 HEYER HEYDEMANN HEYDE.MANN, Julius, 1911 *Ueber akuten und chronischen Dunndarnnerschluss. 31p. 23cm. Berl., P. Brandel, 1937. H EYDEN, Clementine von, 1892- *Ueber die Beeinflussung von Bakterienwachstum durch akzessorische Nahrstoffe. 30p. 8? Heidelb., J. Horning, 1926. HE YDEN, Willy, 1904 *Beitrag zur Frage der Digitoxinbindung am Herzmuskel [Zurich] p.295-313. 8? Berl., F. C. W. Vogel, 1932. Also Arch. exp. Path, 1932, 164: HEYDENHOFFER, Josef, 1907- *Ueber die Haufigkeit und Grade der Coxa vara bei der Arthrosis deformans des Htiftgelenkes. 24p. 8? Miinch., Salesian. Off., 1934. HEYDENREICH [Hans] Rolf, 1911- *Chondrom der Bauchdecken bei Beckenchon- drom. 23p. 23cm. Lpz., A. Edelmann, 1936. HEYDENREICH, Heinz [Walter] 1908- *Ein Beitrag zur Frage der tuberkulosen Aetio- logie von Augenerkrankungen [Munchen] 19p. 8? Wurzb., R. Mavr, 1934. HEYDENREICH, Robert, 1913- *Die Bedeutung der Mundbodenphlegmone fiir die Zahnheilkunde. 27p. 21cm. Miinch., J. B. Grassl, 193S. HEYDER, Otto, 1893- *Die Bedeutung des Ceberbisses fiir die Aetiologie und Therapie dei Paradentosen. 63p. 8° [Lpz., n. pub., 1930] HEYDER, Otto [Heinrich Fritz] 1900- *l)ie Srhutzmassnahmen gegen Geschlechts- krankheiten in der Reichsmarine und ihre Aus- wirkung auf den tiesehleehtskrankenzugang der let/ten Jahre | Munster] 2<)p. 8? Quaken- bruck, R. Kleinert, 1928. HEYDKAMP, Fritz, 1S9S- *Experi- menteller Beitrag zur Pathogenese der Gicht. 16p. 8? Berl., E. Ebering, 1925. HEYDNER, Walter, *Ueber die Bedeutung des Foramen parietale am Schadel [Wurzburg] lip. tab. 8? Berl., W. de Gruyter & co., 1930. HEYDRICH, Georg, 1911- *Ueber Un- falle und iible Folgeerscheinungen in der zahn- arztlichen Praxis [Erlangen] 22p. 8? Fiirth i. Bay, L. Walbinger, 1934. Also Zbl. allg. Path, 1929, 46: HEYELMANN, G[ustav Friedrich] 1897- *Ueber das Wesen (Aetiologie, Pathogenese) und die moderne Systematik der sogenannten hamor- rhagischen Diathesen. 31p. 8? Bonn, H. Ludwig, 1931. HEYER, Friedrich Wilhelm, 1911- *Die Messmethoden und Grossenprobleme der roten Blutkorperchen unter besonderer Beriicksichti- gung der Grosse der Erythrozyten im Sauglings- alter [Greifswald] 55p. 21cm. Lengerich, Lenge- rich. Handelsdr., 1937. HEYER, Gustav Richard, 1890- Hypno- sis and hypnotherapy, p.95-237. 12? Lond., C. W. Daniel co. [1931] In Suggestion therapy (Jolowicz, E.) Lond. [1931] ---- Der Organismus der Seele; eine Ein- fiihrung in die analytische Seelenheilkunde. lolp. pl. diagrs. S° Miinch., J. F. Lehmann, 1932. ---- The same. The organism of the mind; an introduction to analytical psychotherapy; transl. by Eden and Cedar Paul, xiii, 271p. pl. S° Lond., K. Paul, Trench, Trubner & co., 1933! ---- Praktische Seelenheilkunde; eine Ein- fiihrung in die Psychotherapie fiir Aerzte und Studierende. 184p. illust. 8? Miinch., J. F. Lehmann, 1935. HEYER, Hans, 1903- *Experimentellr und klinische Versuche mit ionisierter Luft [Frankfurt] 25p. 8? Offenbach, Offenbacher Nachr., 1934. HEYERDAHL, Severin Andreas, 1870-1940 Dale. T. [Obituary] Nord. med, 1040, 8: 1873, portr. - Forssell. G. [Obituarv] Acta radiol, Stockh, 1940, 21: 62'' 32, portr. HEYGSTER [Karl Heinrich] Hans, 1905 *Pupillenstorungen und Lebensdauer. p. 166-87 8° [Kiel, Karger, 1931] HEYKEN, Rudolf, 1899- *S<•hiiller- Christian'sche Krankheit (Lipoidgranulomatose) Beziehungen dieser Krankheit zu Affektionen an Kiefer und Zahnen; Bericht iiber einen Fall, der Sehuller-Christian'sche Krankheit vortauschte 40p. 8? Bonn, P. Kubens, 1934. HEYLAND, Walter, 1896- *Zwei Falle angeborener Ziihne. 19p. 8? Tiib., E. Gobel, 1932. HEYLER, Robert. *Contribution a l'etude de l'asperge et de ses maladies parasitaires [Strasbourg] lOlp. pl. 24cm. Par., Jouve & cie, 1937. HEYM, Hans, 1910- Feber das beid- hiindige Tastmass. I. p. 166- SS. 8? Jena, F Gobert, 1935. Also Zschr. Psychol. Physiol. Sinnesorg, 2. Abt, 1934, 65: HEYMACH, Alfred [August] 1908- *Bei- trag zum Vorkommen von Trichomonaden im kranken und gesunden Uterus geschlachteter Rinder. 36p. 20>^cm. Giessen, O. Kindt, 1935 HEYMAN, Ernst James, 1882- See League of Nations. Health Organisation. Annual report on the results of radiotherapy in cancer of Ihe uterine cervix, v.l. 74p. 24cm. Geneva, 1937. Also League of Nations. Health Organisation. Atlas, v. p. 18Mcm. [Stockh, 1938] HEYMANN, Annemarie, 1905- *Die in der Universitats-Frauenklinik zu Kiel von 1923 zu 1933 behandelten Falle von Hyperemesis gravidarum [Kiel] 22p. 2 tab. 8? Wurzb., K. Triltsch, 1933. HEYMANN, Bruno, 1871- Robert Koch. 1. Teil: 1843-82. 3 p. 1. 353p. illust. pl. portrs. 8? Lpz., Akad. Verlagsges., 1932. ----& FREUDENBERG, Karl. Morbiditat und Mortalitat der Bergleute im Ruhrgebiet. viii, 200p. 8? Essen, G. D. Baedeker, 1925. HEYMANN, Erich. Allgemeine Einfiihrung in die Kolloidchemie fiir Mediziner. 44p. 8? Berl., H. Kornfeld, 1927. Forms H. 373-74, Berl. Klin. HEYMANN, Giinter, 1911- *Beitrage zur pathologischen Physiologie des Insulin- schocks. 15p. 21cm. Bresl., Bresl. Genossen- schafts-Buchdr., 1937. HEYMANN, Hermann, 1908- ♦Experi- mentelle Untersuchungen uber die Festigkeit und Dehnbarkeit der Sklera von Schweinsaugen. 23p. 3 tab. 22^.em. Erlangen, K. Dores, 1935. HEYMANN, Karl, 1904- *Ueber das freie Radikal Phenyl und iiber das Auftreten freier Radikale bei chemischen Reaktionen. 39p. 8? Miinch. [n. pub.] 1929. HEYMANN [Karl] Gerhard, 1903- *Er- gebnisse der Therapie der Spondylitis tuberculosa [Berlin] 49p. 8? Charlottenb., Gebr. Hoff- mann, 1930. HEYMANN, Kurt, 1888- Die Wismut- behandlung der Syphilis. 94p. 8? Berl., H. Pusch, 1925. Also Melchior, Adolf. Subkutane Sauerstofftherapie. l.Vtp. 8? Amersfoort, 1932. HEYMANN, Kurt Willi, 1899- *Beitrage zur Kenntnis der Epidermolysis bullosa heredi- HEYMANN taria Breslau] p.624-36. 8? Berl., J. Springer, 1927. Also Arch. Derm. Syph, Berl, 1927, 153: HEYMANN, Rudolf, 1858-1936. Lange. Nekrolog. Zschr. Hals &c. Heilk, 1935-36, 39: p. iii. HEYMANN, Sylvia. *Ueber einen Fall von unspezifischer eitriger doppelseitiger chronischer Parotitis im Kindesalter. 15p. 8? Basel, Philograph. Verlag, 1934. HEYMANN, Wilhelm, 1911- *Das Man- delproblem [Miinchen] 32p. 21cm. Bleiche- rode, C. Nieft, 1938. HEYMANN-HEIMS, Paul, 1849-1931. BI. [Biography] Zschr. Laryng, 1929, 18: 3, portr.— Kronenberg, E. Nekrolog. Arch. Ohr. &c. Heilk, 1931-32, 130: 271-3.—Kuttner, A. Nekrolog. Zschr. Hals &c. Heilk, 1931-32, 30: 299.—Marschik [Biography] Mschr. Ohrenh, 1929, 63: 115-19, portr. ------ Nekrolog. Ibid, 1932, 66: 257. HEYMANNS, Eduard, 1907- *Pflege und Aufzucht der Friihgeburten an der Universi- tats-Frauenklinik in den Jahren 1928-33. 12p. 8? Kiel, H. Liidtke, 1934. HEYMANS, Cforneille] 1892- See Heymans, J. F, & Heymans, C. Verfahren, um den solierten Hundekopf durch Anastomose [&c] p. 1075-9. 8". Berl, 1932.------ Perfusion des isolierten Kopfes vom isolierten Herz-Lungen-Praparat [&c] p. 1081-3. 8? Berl, 1932. ------ Verfahren zur Hyper- und Hypothermisation. p.1085-92. 8°. Berl, 1932. ------ Versuchsanordnung zur fraktionierten und kontinuierlichen quantitativen Bestimmung [&c] p.1093-102. 8! Berl, 1932. See also Cheval. V. Hommage national de l'Acadfimie royale de medecine de Belgique au professeur C. Heymans. Bruxelles med, 1939-40, 20: 427-9. For portrait see Cas. lek. cesk, 1936, 75: 703. ---BOUCKAERT, Jan J., & REGNIERS, P. Le sinus carotidien et la zone homologue cardio- aortique; physiologie, pharmacologie, pathologie, clinique. 2 p. 1. 334p. illust. diagrs. 8? Par., G. Doin & cie, 1933. HEYMANS, Corneille, & REMOUCHAMPS, L. Contributions a la pharmacodynamie et a la physiologie du cceur; action centrale et reflexe de l'adrenaline et de la pression circulatoire sur la frequence du cceur. 32p. 8? Brux., 1927. Forms No. 6, v.23. 1926-27, Mem. couron. Acad. mid. Belgique. HEYMANS, Jean Francois, 1859-1932. [Necrologie] Rev. beige sc. mid., 1932, 4: 237-9, portr. ---& HEYMANS, Cforneille] Verfahren, um den isolierten Hundekopf durch Anastomose mit dem Blutkreislauf eines anderen Hundes uberlebend zu halten. p. 1075-9. 8? Berl., Urban & Schwarzenberg, 1932. In Abt. 5, T. 2, pt 2, Handb. biol. Arbeitsmeth. (Abderhalden E.) . ---Perfusion des isolierten Kopfes vom isolierten Herz-Lungen-Praparat aus beim selben Hund. p. 1081-3. 8? BerL, Urban & Schwar- zenberg, 1932. In Abt. 5, T. 2, pt 2, Handb. biol. Arbeitsmeth. (Abderhal- den, E.) ---- Verfahren zur Hyper- und Hypothermi- sation der Saugetiere durch Erwarmung und Abkiihlung des Blutes des durch Anastomose ver- bundenen carotido-jugularen Kreislauf es. p.1085- 92. 8? Berl., Urban & Schwarzenberg, 1932. In Abt. 5, T. 2, pt 2, Handb. biol. Arbeitsmeth. (Abderhal- den, E.) ----Versuchsanordnung zur fraktionierten und kontinuierlichen quantitativen Bestimmung des C02 der Exspirationsluft. p.1093-102. 8? Berl., Urban & Schwarzenberg, 1932. In Abt. 5, T. 2, pt 2, Handb. biol. Arbeitsmeth. (Abderhalden, E ) HEYMER, Adolf, 1902- *Zur Thorako- kaustik [Berlin] p.37-44. roy. 8? Lpz., J. A. Barth, 1930. Also Zschr. Tuberk, 1930-31, 59: 227475—vol. 7, 4th series----41 HEYMER HEYMER, Eberhard, 1909- *Zur Frage der dentalen Herdinfektion [Bonn] 19p. 3 1 8? Diiren, M. Danielewski, 1933. HEYN, Gunther, 1911- *Die Blutbild- veranderungen bei Huhnern wahrend der Mauser (mit Beitragen zur normalen Hamatologie des Huhnes) 64p. 8? Lpz., A. Edelmann, 1935. HEYN, Roman, 1909- *Fraktur des Dens epistropheus. 17p. 8? Wurzb., Gebr. Memminger, 1934. HEYN, Walther. Die gesetzliche Kranken- versicherung; Versicherungspflicht und Ver- sicherungsberechtigung; Beitrage Und Leistungen. 128p. 8? Berl., Deut. Versicherungs-Ztg [1937] HEYN, Werner, 1911- *Untersuchungen zum Lichtsinn der Albinos [Kiel] 28p. 21cm. Ochsenfurt, Fritz & Rappert, 1938. HEYN, Wilhelm. Editor of Gruber, M. v. Hygiene des Geschlechtslebens. Neubearb. 147p. 19cm. Berl, 1930. HEYNE [Ernst Louis] Curt, 1912- ♦Unter- suchungen uber die Erblichkeit des Os tibiale externum. 32p. 8? Lpz., A. Edelmann, 1937. HEYNE [Friedrich Karl] Johannes, 1900- *Zahnuntersuchungen im Lumineszenzlicht [Rostock] 32p. 8? Lippstadt, Thiele, 1932. HEYNE, Heinz, 1910- *Ueber die Ausbreitung entziindlicher Vorgange in der Mundhohle. 26p. 8? Rostock, C. Hinstorff, 1935. HEYNEA. See also Poison. Gimlette, J. D. Tangis sarang burong. In his Malay Poisons, 3. ed, Lond, 1929, 186. HEYNEMANN, Theodor, 1878- Die Tuberkulose der weiblichen Genitalien und des Peritoneums. p. 179-465. roy. 8? [Miinch., 1933] In Handb. Gyn. (J. Veit & W. Stockel) 3. Aufl. Munch, 1933. 8. Bd, 1. T. HEYNEN, Ulrich, 1909- *Ueber den plastischen Ersatz der Harnrohrendefekte mit besonderer Berucksichtigung der perinealen Hypo- spadie [Konigsberg] 26p. roy. 8? Lpz., G. Thieme, 1932. Also Zschr. Urol.,1932, 26: HEYNG, Fritz, 1909- *Ein Beitrag zu den sogenannten Nasenzahnen [Bonn] 26p. 8? Duisburg-Hamborn, W. Knaup, 1932. HEYNINX, Aflbert] Essai d'olfactique physio- logique. 289p. 4? Brux., F. Larcier, 1919. HEYNOLD, Gerhardt [Martin Ludwig] 1908- *Histochemische Untersuchungen iiber die Abhangigkeit des normalen Bleigehaltes mensch- licher Knochen vom Lebensalter [Leipzig] 16p. 8° Zeulenroda, A. Oberreuter, 1937. HEYNSIUS, A. Bijdrage tot eene physische verklaring van de abnormale geruischen in het vaatstelsel. 301p. 11 pl. (1 fold.) 8? [n. p., n. pub., 18-?] HEYRODT, Horst, 1911- *Ueber be- ginnende Collumcarcinome, die durch Radium- bestrahlung nicht geheilt wurden; zur Frage der sogenannten galoppierenden Collumcarcinome [Heidelberg] 35p. 21cm. Walldorf, F. Lamade, 1937. HEYROTH, Francis Farnham, 1894- See Ellis, C, & Wells, A. A. The chemical action of ultra- violet rays. 961p. 23Hcm. N. Y, 1941. HEYSER, Kurt Friedrich, 1902- *Ueber Missbildung des Sinus rectus bei einem Fall von Hydrocephalus internus chronicus [Leipzig] 46p. 8? Zeulenroda, A. Oberreuter, 1931. HEYWOOD 642 HIBERNATION HEYWOOD, Nathaniel Arthur. See Hunt, D. G, & Phillips. J. F. Heywood and Massey's lunacy practice. 6. ed. 6S7p. 25&cm. Lond, 1939. HEZEL, Ernst, 1911- *Die Bang-Infek- tion bei Mensch und Rind mit Berucksichtigung der Verhaltnisse in Wurttemberg [Munchen] 23p. 21cm. Wurzb., K. Triltsch, 1937. HEZNER, Walter, 1909- *Die Rontgen- bestrahlungserfolge bei Wirbelsaulenaffektionen [Wurzburg] 39p. 21cm. Ochsenfurt, Fritz & Rappert, 1936. HEZON, Guy Rene, 1905- *Contribution a l'etude de la tuberculose canine (recherches cytologiques sur les exsudats sereux) [Alfort] 60p. 8? Evreux, Impr. C. Herissey, 1927. HIATUS hernia. See under Diaphragm. HIBBARD, Rosa M., 1871-1937. Tributes to Rosa M. Hibbard. Week. Bull. Jackson Co. M. Soc, 1937, 31: 817-23, portr. HIBBEN, Frank C, & BRYAN, Kirk. Evi- dences of early occupation in Sandia Cave, New Mexico, and other sites in the Sandia-Manzano region, with appendix on Correlation of the de- posits of Sandia Cave, New Mexico, with the glacial chronology, vi, 64p. 15 pl. 3 diagr. 24K>cm. Wash., Smithson. Inst., 1941. Forms No. 23, v.99, Smithson. Misc. Collect. (Pub. 3636) HIBBS, Russell Aubra, 1869-1932. Origina1 papers, p.93-130. 8? N. Y., Columbia Univ Press, 1935. In Russell A. Hibbs, pioneer in orthopedic surgery (G. M. Goodwin) N. Y, 1935, 93-130. For biography see Bull. N. York Acad. M, 1932, 2. ser, 8: 676. Also .1. Bone Surg, 1933, 15: 253. Also Rev. cir. Hosp. Judrez, Mix., 1933, 4: 69 (Farril) See also Goodwin, G. M. Russell A. Hibbs, pioneer in orthopedic surgery, 1869-1932. 136p. 8? N. Y, 1935. Also Master surgeons of America. Surg. Gyn. Obst, 1937, 64: 1096-9, portr. HIBERNATION. See also Anabiosis. Wyss, O. A. M. *Winterschlaf und Warme- haushalt, untersucht am Siebenschlafer (Myoxus glis) p.599-635. 8? Ziir., 1932. Also Arch. ges. Physiol, 1932, 229: Adler, L. Der Winterschlaf. In Handb. norm. path. Physiol. (A. Berthe & G. Bergman) Berl, 1926, 17: 105-33.- Aldous, S. E. A hibernating black bear with cubs. J. Mam- mal, 1937, 18: 466-8.—Davies, W. M. Hibernation of Luciha sericata, Mg. Nature, Lond, 1929, 123: 759.—Endres, G. Neuere Untersuchungen iiber den Winterschlaf. Verh. Phys. med. Ges. Wurzburg, 1930, n. F, 55: 172-87.—Ferdmann, D., & Feinschmidt, O. Der Winterschlaf. Erg. Biol, 1932, 8: 1-74.—Gautrelet, J. L'hibernation. Presse mid., 1939, 47: 253.—Gelineo, S. Sur la thermogen&se de I'hibernant pendant Viti. C. rend. Soc. biol, 1938, 127: 1357-9.—Goldschmidt, R. Untersuchungen zur Genetik der geographischen Variation; Analyse der Ueberwinterungszeit als Anpassungscharakter, Arch. Entwmech, 1932, 126: 674-768, 2 ch, 10 tab.—Hoepke, H, & Nikolaus, K. Ueber die Bedeutung der Winterschtaf- driise des Igels. Zschr.'mikr. anat. Forsch, 1939, 46: 1-15.— Holmquist, A. M. Studies in arthropod hibernation; the hibernation of the ant, Formica ulkei Emery. Physiol Zool 1928, 1: 325-57.—Johnson, G. E. Hibernation of the 13- lined ground-squirrel, Citellus tridecemlineatus (Mitchell) a comparison of the normal and hibernating states. J. Exp Zool, 1928, 50: 15-20, eh.------Hibernation in mammals Q. Rev. Biol, 1931, 6: 439-61.—Martell. Der Winterschlaf der Tiere. Munch, tierarztl. Wschr, 1930, 81: 195-7.—Mathias, P. Sur la biologie du h£risson, Erinaceus europaeus (L)' Bull. Soc. zool. France, 1929, 54: 463-6.—Polimanti. 6 Lethargie und Winterschlaf (latentes Leben) Wien klin Wschr, 1936. 49: 925-9.—Rail, U. M., & Demiashev, M. p! [Annual hibernation burrows of the ground squirrelsl Vest mikrob, 1934, 13: 119-28.— Rochat. R. R. Hibernom. Acta neerl. morph, 1940, 3: 301.—Schachter. D., & Schaechter M Etude sur l'hibernation. Rev. m6d. Nancy, 1938, 66: 919-46 — Seiko, I, F. Hibernation of the striped skunk in Iowa ' J Mammal.. 1938, 19: 320-4.—Shaw, W. T. Observations on the hibernation of ground squirrels. J. Agr. Res, 1925-26 31- 7ol-9—Swanson. G., & Evans, C. The hibernation of certain bats in southern Minnesota. J. Mammal, 1936 17- 39-43__ Uiberall, H. Daa Problem des Winterschlaf es. Arch ges. Physiol, 1934, 234: 78-97— Whelden, R. M. Hibernation of Eptesicus fuscus in a New Hampshire building. J. Mammal 1941, 22: 203.—Zeuthen. E. On the hibernation of Spongilla lacustris (L.) Zschr. vergl. Physiol, 1938-39, 26: 537-47. ---- Endocrine aspect. Coninx-Girardet, B. *Beitrage zur Kenntnis innersekretorischer Organe des Murmelticrca (Arctomys marmota L.) und ihrer Bdziehungen zum Problem des Winterschlafes [Zurich p.161-224. 8? Stockh., 1927. Also Acta zool, 1927, 8: Aron, M, & Kayser, C. Le phanomene do l'adaptation thermique et sa relation avee l'activite thyroidienne apreoiee d'aprds l'examen histologique chez quelques espaces d'hiber- nants. C. rend. Soc. biol, 1939, 130: 395-7. ------ Role de la temperature dans le dfeterminisme du sornmeil hibernal; importance du relai endocrinien dans ce mecanisme. Ibid ' 132: 120-2.—Boyd, E. M, Clarke. M. E. [et al.] Retention of water by pituitary (posterior lobe) extract in winter frogs Proc. Soc. Exp. Biol, N. Y, 1940, 45: 20-3.—Courrier. R, & Gros, G. Action des substances urinaires gonadotropes chez la marmotte hibernante. C. rend. Soc. biol, 1934, 115: 1097- 100.—Faraggiana, R. Sulla presenza di numerose figure di degenerazione nei pancreas esocrino di Rana agilis adulta durante l'ibernazione. Monit. zool. ital, 1934, 45: 239-42.— Foster, M. A, Foster, R. C, & Meyer, R. K. Hibernation and the endocrines. Endocrinology, 1939, 24: 603-12.— Jann, W. Die Bedeutung gewisser Hormone bei lethargischen Zustanden und Winterschlaf (Hypnose bei Froschen) Helvet. med. acta 1937, 4: 355-70.—Johnson, G. E, & Hanawalt, V. B. Hiberna- tion of the 13-lined ground squirrel Citellus tridecemlineatus (Mitchel) influence of thyroxin, pituitrin and desiccated thymus and thyroid on hibernation. Am. Natur, 1930, 64: 272-84.—Kayser, C, & Aron, M. Cycle d'activit6 saisonni^re des glandes endocrines chez un hibernant, le hamster, Cricetus frumentarius. C. rend. Soc. biol, 1938, 129: 225.----- Modifications structurales de la m6dullo-surr6nale dans l'adap- tation thermique des hibernants. Ibid, 1939, 130: 397-400.— Suomalaincn, P. Ueber den Winterschlaf des Igels; der Adre- nalingehalt der Nebennieren. Biochem. Zschr, 1937-38, 295: 145-53.—Sweet, J. E., & Hoskins, W. H. Androgen in the woodchuck hibernating gland. Proc. Soc. Exp. Biol, N. Y, 1940, 45: 60-2.—Wendt. C. F. Ueber Wirkungen eines Extraktes aus dem braunen Fettgewebe des winterscnlafenden Igels; vorlaufige Mitteilung. Zschr. physiol. Chem, 1937, 249: p. iv ---- Metabolism. Ackermann, J. Histochemische Untersuchungen (iber den Gehalt an Lipiden und Karotenoiden im Darm des iiber winternden Frosches. Bull, internat. Acad, polon. sc, 1937, s£r. B, 2: 241-83— Baldwin, F. M, & Johnson, K. LeR. Effects of hibernation on the rate of oxygen consumption in the 13-lined ground squirrel. J. Mammal, 1941, 22: 180-2.— Brunner, C, & Endress, H. Der Einfluss der Umgebungs- temperatur auf den Ernahrungszustand der Fische bei der Winterruhe. Zschr. Biol, 1929, 89: 85-113.—Burbank, R. C, & Young, J. Z. Temperature changes and winter sleep of bats. J. Physiol, Lond, 1934, 82: 459-67.—Dontcheff, L, & Kayser, C. Explications de certains quotients respiratoires aberrants chez les hibernants. C. rend. Soc. biol, 1935, 118: 81-3. ------ La d6pense d'6nergie chez la marmotte en itat d'hi- bernation. Ibid, 119: 565-8.—Dreyer, W. A. The effect of hibernation and seasonal variation of temperature on the respiratory exchange of Formica ulkei Emery. Physiol. Zool, 1932, 5:301-31. Also repr.—Feinschmidt, O. Ueberden Umsatz von Adenosintriphosphorsaure im Muskel; der Umsatz der Adenosintriphosphorsaure in den Muskeln von winter- schlafhaltenden Tieren. Biochem. Zschr, 1936, 286: 290-4 — Fleischmann, W. Beitrage zur Physiologie der Gewebsatmung nach Untersuchungen an Winterschlafern. Arch. ges. Physiol, 1929, 222: 541-7.—Gautier, C. Existe-t-il des reserves de proteines dans le foie des grenouilles au debut de l'hibernatioii? Bull. Soc. chim. biol. Par, 1931, 13: 143-7.—Gelineo, S. Sur la thermog6n£se de I'hibernant lors du passage de l'etat de veille k l'etat de torpeur. C. rend. Soc. biol, 1938, 127: 1360.—Gubarcv, E. M., Bystrenin, A. I., & Lugovaia, L. V. |R61e of fat in hibernation of animals! Vest, mikrob, 1939-40, 18: 133-8.—Hook, W. E., & Barron, E. S. G. The respiration of brown adipose tissue and kidney of the hibernating and non- hibernating ground squirrel. Am. J. Physiol, 1941, 133: 56; 334.—Kayser, C. Echanges respiratoires chez le spermo- phile k l'etat de sornmeil hibernal. C. rend. Soc. biol, 1937, 126: 1222-4. ------ Echanges respiratoires du loir, Myoxus glis, pendant le sornmeil hibernal. Ibid, 1938, 128: 8.5-8. ----— Echanges respiratoires et production de chaleur en fonction de la temperature chez le loir, Myoxus glis, a l'etat de veille et de sornmeil hibernal. Ibid, 1201-4. ----- La d6pense d'6nergie minime chez le hamster, Cricetus fru- mentarius, k l'etat de veille. Ibid, 129: 1162-6. ----- L'hom6othermie imparfaite des hibernants eVeilles est la consequence d'une thermoregulation physique insuffisante. Ibid, 1939, 131: 525-7. ------ Evolution saisonniere de la thermoregulation chimique chez lea hibernants reveilles. Ibid, 893-5. ------ Echanges respiratoires des hibernants HIBERNATION 643 HIBERNATION reveilles. Ann. physiol. Par, 1939, 15: 1087-219. ------ Echanges respiratoires des hibernants k l'etat de sornmeil hibernal. Ibid., 1940, 16: 127-221, pl. —:--- & Dell, P. Signification des variations du quotient respiratoire en fonc- tion de la temperature du milieu chez le hamster reveille. C. rend. Soc. biol, 1937, 126: 698-700.—Meyer, P.. & Thibau- det, M. A. Les variations du poids pendant l'hibernation de l'estivation des helices. Ibid, 124: 182-5.—Suomalainen, P. Ueber den Winterschlaf des Igels; der Vitamin-C-Gehalt einiger Organe. Skand. Arch. Physiol, Berl., 1938, 78: 272-82. ------ Ueber den Winterschlaf des Igels; der Carotin- und Vitamin-A-Stoffwechsel. Ibid, 1939-40, 83: 94-103 — Takagi. K. Beitrage zur Biochemie des Winterschlafs; iiber das Verhalten verschiedener Phosphorverbindungen und Phosphatasen von Organen und Geweben der Krote im Winter- schlaf. Mitt. Med. Akad. Kioto, 1938, 23: 1097.—Timon- David, J. Sur les variations des graisses de reserve pendant revolution de la pyrale du mais (Pyrausta nubitalis Hiibn) C. rend. Soc. biol, 1928* 99: 1799. --- Pathology. Barelli, L. Ricerche sperimentali su la febbre negli animali ibernanti. Boll. Soc. ital. biol. sper., 1933, 7: 1507-10 — Jadin, J. Les infections chez le 16rot commun. C. rend. Soc biol, 1931, 106: 493. ------ L'influence de l'hibernation chez les terots: sur leur receptivite aux intoxications et aux infections et sur leur immunisation. Arch, internat. med. exp, Liege, 1932, 7: 137-48.—Jahnel. F. Ueber das Verhalten von Rekurrensspirochaten im Organismus winterschlafender Tiere. Zschr. Immunforsch, 1938, 92: 253-69.—Zabolotny. D. Infektion und Immunitat bei winterschlafhaltenden Tieren. Zbl. Bakt, 1. Abt., 1928, 106: 397. --- Pharmacology. Borak, J., & Uiberall, H. Ueber den Einfluss der Ront- genstrahlen auf winterschlafende Tiere. Wien. klin. Wschr, 1936, 49: 109-11.—Cassens, A. Ueber die Beeinflussung des Winterschlafs durch Vitamin D3. Zschr. ges. exp. Med, 1939, 106: 521-30.—Cicardo, V. H. Le excitabiUdad cardfaca del Bufo arenarum (Hens.) modificaciones producidas durante el invierno; accion de la acetilcolina. Rev. Soc. argent, biol, 1935, 11: 454-63.—Dworkin, S, & Finney, W. H. Artificial hibernation in the woodchuck (Arctomys monax) Am. J. Physiol, 1927, 80: 75-81.—Klar, E. Ueber den Einfluss verschiedener Carotinoide auf den Eintritt des Winterschlaf es. Zschr. ges. exp. Med, 1939. 105: 161-7.—Nitschke, A. Ueber die Beeinflussung des Winterschlafs durch bestrahltes Ergo- sterin. Ibid, 1932, 82: 227-35.—Pfeiffer, C, Foster, M. A., & Slight. D. The effect of analeptic drugs on hibernation in the 13-lined ground squirrel. J. Pharm. Exp. Ther, 1939, 67: 307-12.—Suomalainen, P. Artificial hibernation. Nature, Lond, 1939, 144:443. --- Physiology. Abeloos, M. Sur la biologie et l'hibernation des Timarchas (coieopteres, chrysomelides) C. rend. Soc. biol, 1937, 124: 511-3.—Barthelemy, H. Recherches biomdtriques et experi- mentales sur l'hibernation, la maturation et la surmaturation de la grenouille rousse (Rana fusca) C. rend. Acad, so.. 1926, 182: 1653. ------ Concentration saline du sang, du liquide de la cavite generate et des produits genitaux cf et 9 de la grenouille rousse (Rana fusca) pendant la cycle annuel et l'hibernation. Arch. phys. biol. Par, 1933-34, 11: 111734.— Bevagnik, A. Sulla soglia di eccitazione dei muscoli lisci (stomaco) di alcuni animali letargici (Emys. Bufo, Rana) Riv. biol, 1935, 19: 69-77.—Bodine, J. H. Hibernation and diapause in certain Orthoptera; diapause; a theory of its mechanism. Physiol. Zool, 1932, 5: 549-54.—Bruman, F. Experimenteller Beitrag zur Phvsiologie des Winterschlafes. Zschr. vergl. Physiol, 1929, 10: 419-30.—Busnel, R. G, & Drilhon, A. Etude biochimique du Leptinotarsa decemlineata Say pendant l'hivernation. C. rend. Soc. biol, 1937, 124: 916.—Calabro, Q. Sull'attivit^ vagale degli animali letargici. Riv. biol., 1939, 27: 332-40, pl.—Chu, C. H. A cytological study on the hibernating toad; changes in the Golgi apparatus. Chin. J. Physiol, 1933, 7: 269-85, 4 pl.—Cori Delia Nera, M. Ricerche chimiche, fisico-chimiche e morfologiche sul sangue di Testudo graeca nelTestate e durante il sonno invernale. Boll. Ist. zool. Roma (1925) 1926, 3: 71-85.—Courrier, R. La degenerescence walierienne chez les chauves-souris hibernantes. C. rend. Soc. biol., 1926, 94: 1385 — Dische, Z., Fleischmann, W., & Trevani, E. Zur Frage des Zusammenhanges zwischen Winterschlaf und Hypoglykamie. Arch. ges. Physiol, 1931, 227: 235-8.—Dulzetto, F. II glutatione nella ibernazione e nei risveglio. Boll. Soc. ital. biol. sper, 1932, 7: 480. Also Zschr. vergl. Physiol, 1932, 16: 218-28.—Ferdman, D. L. [Bio- chemistry of hibernation] Usp. sovrem. biol, 1936, 5: 431-50. ------& Feinschmidt, O. Beitrage zur Biochemie des Winter- schlafs; uber die chemischen Bestandteile der Muskeln von winterschlafhaltenden Tieren. Biochem. Zschr., 1932, 248: 67-100. ------ Ueber die chemischen Bestandteile des Blutes winterschlafhaltender Tiere. Ibid, 107-14—Feyel. P. Sur un phenomene d'excr6tion d'hemoglobine dans le rein de la grenouille hibernante. C. rend. Soc. biol, 1931, 107: 551.— Filhol, J. Modifications des constituants cellulaires dans le vesicules multifides des puknones au cours de l'hibernation et du repos secretaire. Ibid, 1935, 118: 1273-6.—Fleischmann, W. Physiologie des Winterschlafes. Biol, gen., Wien, 1931, 7: 621-9.------ Leukopenic wahrend des Winterschlafes. Arch. ges. Physiol, 1934, 234: 489-91—Fosi, V. Ricerche sui girini ibernanti di Rana esculenta dei dintorni di Siena Arch zool. ital, 1933, 18: 287-329, 2 pl.—Friedman, M. H. F, & Armour, J. C. Gastric secretion in the groundhog (Marmota monax) during hibernation. J. Cellul. Physiol, 1936 8: 201-1 L—Gorer, PA. The physiology of hibernation. Biol. Rev. Cambridge Philos. Soc, 1930, 5: 213-30.—Herlant, M. Recherches d'histophysiologie genitale chez le herisson hiber nant. Arch. anat. micr. Par, 1932, 28: 335-62, 4 pl. ------ Recherches sur les potentialites de developpement des ceufs obtenus par ovulation provoquee chez in chauvesouris en hibernation. Bull. Acad. Belgique, 1934, 5. ser, 20: cl. sc, 359-66.—Hess, W. R. Beziehungen zwischen Winterschlaf und Aussentemperatur beim Siebenschlafer. Zschr. vergl. Physiol, 1938-39, 26: 529-36.—Hdepke, H. Die Milz von Igel und Fledermaus in und nach dem Winterschlaf. Verh. Anat. Ges, 1931, 40: 216-28. ------ Beitrage zur Mor- phologie und Physiologie des Lymphgewebes; die Milz winter- schlafender Tiere. Zschr. ges. Anat, 1. Abt, 1932, 99: 411- 76.—Holzapfel, R. A. The cyclic character of hibernation in frogs. Q. Rev. Biol, 1937, 12: 65-84.—Johnson. G.E. Hiber- nation of the thirteen-lined ground squirrel, Citellus tride- cemlineatus (Mitchel) the general process of waking from hibernation. Am. Natur, 1929, 63: 171-80. ------ The rise in respiration, heart beat and temperature in waking from hibernation. Biol. Bull, 1929, 57: 107-29. ------ Food, light, confined air, precooling, castration and fatness in relation to production of hibernation. Ibid, 1930, 59: 114-27.— Jordan, H. J, & Postma, N. Shape and slope of rest curves of the stretched snail's foot (Helix pomatia) in relation to its water content. J. Physiol. USSR, 1937. 22: 356-64.—Klar, E. Zur Kenntnis des Chemismus im Winterschlaf. Zschr. ges. exp. Med, 1938, 104: 105-15.—Meyer, P., & Thibaudet. M. A. Les modifications du milieu interieur pendant l'hibernation et l'estivation des helices. C. rend. Soc. biol, 1937, 124: 185-7. Recherches sur l'hibernation et l'estivation des helices; la taille moyenne des particules collo'idales de l'hemolymphe. Ibid, 653-5.—Moraldi, M. La soglia di eccitazione della corteccia cerebrale di Bufo vulgaris durante il letargo, il risveglio, la veglia. Riv. biol, 1934, 17: 547-51.—Nitschke, A, & Maier, E. Ueber das Vergiftungsbild nach Injektion von Extrakten aus lymphatischem Gewebe (P-Substanz) und seine Beziehung zum Winterschlaf. Zschr. ges. exp. Med, 1932, 82: 215-26.—Peter, H. Die Gaumenmandeln des Igels im Winter- schlaf. Zschr. ges. Anat, 1. Abt, 1932, 99: 477-91.—Pi Sufier, A, & Bellido, J. M. L'electrocardiograma en l'estat invernal de la Tortuga. Tr. Soc. biol, Barcel, 1913, 1: 109-11, 2 pl.— Riccioni, B. Sulla scossa muscolare e sul tetano muscolare in alcuni animali letargici (Rana, Bufo, Arctomys, Marmota) alio stato di letargo, risveglio e veglia. Riv. biol, 1936, 21: 256- 71.—Roemer, H. Untersuchungen an den Lymphknoten des Igels im Winterschlaf. Zschr. ges. Anat, 1. Abt, 1932, 99: 492-512.—Salmon, A. Sul meccanismo del letargo dei mammi- feri ibernanti. Riv. biol, 1930, 12: 80-92.—Shunzo, T. Ueber das Verhalten des Chondriosomen in den verschiedenen Organen der Krote beim Winterschlaf und Hungerzustand. Nagoya J. M. Sc, 1929, 4: 38-58, 2 pl.—Stormont, R. T, Foster, M. A, & Pfeiffer, C. Plasma pH, CO2 content of the blood and tissue gas tensions during hibernation. Proc. Soc. Exp. Biol, N. Y, 1939, 42: 56-9. Also repr.—Winiwarter, H. de. Modification de la muqueuse laryngee et tracheale pendant l'hibernation, chez les chiropteres. C. rend. Soc. biol, 1926, 94: 405. HIBISCUS. See also Malvaceae. Carteni, A. Sulle sostanze riducenti del carcade. Q. nutriz, Bologna, 1938, 5: 202-5.—Chevalier, J. Les fleurs d'Hibiscus sabdariffa; leur utilisation en dietetique. Bull. sc. pharm. Par, 1937, 44: 195-8.—Grlebel. C. Hibiscus-Bluten, eine zur Bereitung von Speisen und Getranken dienende Droge, ihr Hauptinhaltsstoff eine neue Saure von Fruchtsaurecharakter fHibiscussaure) Zschr. Untersuch. Lebensmitt, 1939, 77: 561-71.—Shchepkina, T. V. [Anatomical and microchemical examination of the stalks of Hibiscus cannabinus before and after decomposition] Arkh. biol. nauk, 1929, 29: 195; 415; 1930, 30:388; ch. HIBL, Josephus. *De cacodermatibus syphi- liticis. 48p. 21cm. Wien, C. Ueberreuter, 1841. HICCUP. See also names of primary diseases as Ence- phalitis, epidemic, &c; also Diaphragm, Con- vulsion and spasm. Kersting, J. *Ueber den Singultus [Wurz- burg] 24p. 8? Hohenmolsen, 1926. Legardez, A. Contribution a P6tude de la valeur semeiologique du hoquet (myoclonic phreno-glottique) 42p. 8? Par., 1936. Bakker, C. [Medical folklore with respect to hiccup] Ned. tschr. geneesk, 1926, 70: 975-8.—Billman, J. M. Hic- cough. Nat. Eclect. M. Ass. Q, 1934, 25: 143-5.—Black- burne, G: Hiccough or singultus. J. M. Soc. N. Jersey, HICCIP 644 HICCIP 1930, 27: 535.—Boekclman. A. J. [Th hiccup, singultus] i i, n,. -k. gids, 1940, 18: 48 .54.—Brown, K. C. Hiccup. In Cvclop. Med. (Piersol-Bortz) Phila, 1939, 7: 276-80 — Cohn, M. Zum Singultus der Sriuglinge. Deut. med. 'Wschr, 1926, 52: 909-11.—Douthwaite, A. H. Hiccup. Guy's Hosp. Gaz, Lond, 1938, 52: 447-50.—Draper, T. Hiccups. Sind M. J, 1936-37, 9: 177-86.—Esuga, M. Biologische Studien liber Kaki-Shibu. Tr. Soc. path, jap, 1939, 29: 511-5.--- Hutchison, R. Hiccup. Clin. J. Lond, 1928, 57: 409-11.— Kellogg, E. L, & Mover, W. Hiccough. Med. Rec, N. Y, 1935, 142: 441-4.—Mayo, C. W. Hiccup. Surg. Gyn. Obst, 1932, 55: 700-8.—Mladek, A. [The electrocardiogram in hiccup] Cas. lek. cesk.. 1939. 78: 780-9.--Noble, E. C. Hiccup. Canad. M. Ass. J, 1934, 31: 38-41.—Rechnitzer, E. Ueber Diss"zi:iiioi> di-i Atmunu'. den Singultus und seine Beziehungen /ui Annum:. Who. Arch. inn. Med, 1927, 45: 353-76.— Riddell. \V. R. Hippo, rates and hiccup. Canad. J. M. & S, 193u 67: 41-0.------Another word with Hippocrates about hiccup. ^Icd. Rec, N. Y, 1934, 139: 41.—Wagner, I. F. A note on ihe hiccough of the neonate. J. Genet. Psychol, 1938. 52: 233-9. ---- epidemic. See also Influenza. David, A. Le hoquet epidemique. J. sc. med. Lille, 1921, 39: 60-4. ------ Sur l'enc6phalite et le hoquet epidemiques. Ibid, 1923, 41: 62-5. ------ Cinq cas de hoquet epidemique. Ibid, 1925, 43: 65-7. ------ Hoquet epidemique; 3 cas. Ibid, 117.—Delattre. A. Quelques cas de hoquet 6pidemique. Ibid, 41-3.—Mateesco. Sur 6 cas, en 12 jours, de hoquet grippal contagieux. Paris med, 1927, 63: 211.-—Veyrat . Am. J. M. Sc, 1938, 196: 715-7.—Urech'iu. V. I, & Mihale^cu, S. Sur un cas de hoquet rebelle avec autopsie. Bull. Soc. med. h6p. Paris, 1927, 3. ser, 51: 87-9.-- VVeeks, C. Surgery of the phrenic nerve in treatment of intraot- able hiccup. Ann. Surg, 1931, 93: 811-5. ---- Treatment. Tlmoine, G. *Le hoquet post-operatoire et son traitement par le serum sale1 hypertonique. 44p. 25^cm. Par., 1939. Cavina, G. 11 singhiozzo in chirurgia e il suo trattamento con inalazioni di anidride carbonica. Riforma med, 1938, 54: 767-70.—Dutt, K. N. A case of hiccough cured with apo- morphine hydrochloride. Ind. M. Gaz, 1933, 68: 518.— Fuld, E. Behandlung des Singultus. Khn. Wschr, 1928, 7: 871.—Golden, L. A. Control of hiccough with carbon dioxide by a simple rebreathing method. N. England J. M, 1931, 204: 1183. Also repr.—Hanelin, H. A. Treatment of paroxys- mal hiccough with benzedrine sulfate inhalation. J. Michigan M. Soc, 1939. 38: 951.—Hasan-Dzhalalov. G. A. [Method for checking hiccup] Sovet. med, 1941, 5: No. 3. 35.—Hoquet (Lei et sa therapeutique populaire. J. sc. med. Lille, 1921, 39: 80-2.—Kallfelz, H. Ueber den postoperativen Singultus und seine Behandlung. Arch. klin. Chir, 1933-34, 178: 475-81.— Lyon, G. Le houquet et son traitement. Bull, med. Par, 1927, 41: 666-9.—Paulian, D. E, & Bistriceanu, I. [Physiopathology and treatment of nervous hiccup] Spitalul, 1931, 51: 405-8.— Pittman, M. A. Dry ice treatment for hiccough. North Carolina M. J, 1940, 1: 615.—Rasi«. Traitement du hoquet par la haute frequence. Rev. otoneur. Par, 1933, 11: 767.— Rosenfeld, G. Behandlung des Singultus. Med. Welt, 1929, 3: 1152.—Santarelli, M. Un nuovo metodo di cura del sing- hiozzo mediante la compressione del frenico. Med. nuova, Roma, 1935, 26: 3-8.—Schottmiiller, H. Ueber eine wirksame Behandlung des Singultus mit Pyramidon. Miinch. med. Wschr, 1927, 74: 860.—Sheldon, R. T. Experiences with carbon dioxide in hiccough. Current Res. Anesth, 1927, 6: 3)1 4. - Control of hiccup by inhalation of carbon dioxide; report of cases. J. Am. M. Ass, 1927, 89: 1118-21 — Treatment of hiccough. Roche Rev, Nutley, N. J, 1936-37 1: 3 11 3. — Ullrich, G. Beitrag zur Singultusbehandlung Med. Welt, 1935, !): 010.—Varga, L. [Treatment of hiccup] Orv. hetil., 1939, 83: mell, 161-3.—Weissenberg. E. Ueber die Beoinflus-diurkcit des Singultus durch Kurzwellenbehand- lung. Med. KUn, Berl, 1936, 32: 737. HICHENS, Peverell Smythe, 1870-1930. Obituary. Lancet, Lond, 1930, 1: 884. HICKE, Josef, 1901- *Zur Aetiologie und Symptomatologie der traumatischen Epilepsie. 27p. 8? Kiel, K. J. Rossier, 1926. HICKEL, Eugen Richard. *Wohnung und Typhus [Munchen] 14p. 8? Pabjanice, Pawlikowskich, 1929. HICKEL, Richard, 1900- *Reactions, incidents, accidents provoques par les rayons ultra-violets; prophylaxie; traitement. 137p. 8? Par., A. Legrand, 1928. HICKEY, Preston Mannasseh, 1865-1930. Crane, A. W. [Necrology] Am. J. Roentg, 1931, 25: 145- 55, portr.—Edling, L. Obituary. Acta radiol, Stockh, 1930, 11: 658-62.—Obituary. Am. J. Surg, 1930, n. ser, 10: 585, portr. Also J. Am. M. Ass, 1930, 95: 1443.—Pohle, E. A. Nekrolog. Fortsch. Rontgenstrahl, 1931, 43: 249, portr. HICKL, Friedrich Wilhelm, 1903- *TJeber einen Fall von Cholesteatom des Stirnlappens. 28p. 8? Erlangen, K. Dores, 1928. HICKLING, Daniel Percy, 1864-1939. Obituary. J. Am. M. Ass, 1939, 112: 1276. HICKMAN, Cleveland Pendleton, 1895- Laboratory manual in college physiology, xiv, 116p. 8? N. Y., Macmillan co., 1930. ---- Physiological hygiene. xxvi, 493p. illust. diagr. 8? X. Y., Prentice-Hall, 1937. ---- Functional human anatomy; illust. by Frances Miller Hickman, xxxv p. 2 1. 501p. illust. 237km. X. Y., Prentice-Hall, 1940. HICKMAN 645 HIDRADENITIS HICKMAN, Henry Hill, 1800-30. Bandera, B. Las grandes figuras en la historia de la anestesia Henry Hill Hickman. Gac. med. Mexico, 1938, 68: 156-60.— Henry Hill Hickman, centenary, reception at W ellcome His- torical Museum. Brit. M. J, 1930, 1: 713.—[Portrait] In Proc. Dent. Centen. Celebr. (Maryland Dent. Ass.) 1940, 338. HICKMAN, H[enry] R[ichard] B[elcher] 1866- See Buckmaster, G. A, & Hickman, H. R. B. A course of practical physiology. 138p. 12? Bristol, 1920. HICKOK, Galen R. California State Board of Medical Examiners; historical sketch. 4p. X? Chic, 1920. HICKS, Frances Ross. The mental health of teachers. 4 1. 36p. .8? Nashville, Tenn., George Peabody Coll. Teachers, 1934. Forms No. 123, Contr. Educ. Peabody Coll. Teachers. HICKS, John Athelstan Braxton, 1885-1935. Obituary. Brit. M. J, 1935, 1: 856. Also J. Path. Bact, Cambr, 1935, 41: 207. Also Lancet, Lond, 1935, 1: 967. HIDALGO-CARPIO, Luis, 1818-79. Torres Torija, J. Dos medicos mexicanos ilustres, los doc- tores Luis Hidalgo Carpio y Agustin Andrade. Mem. Acad. nac. cienc. Antonio Alzate, 1940, 54: 541-52, 2 portr. HIDALGO-LIZALDE, Daniel, 1899- *L'emploi du salicylate du soude intraveineux et les autres tentatives therapeutiques au cours du syndrome de Parkinson post-encephalitique. 68p. 8? Par., M. Vign6, 1928. HIDDEMA, Abe. *Over den index vocalis [Groningen] 92p. 8? De Bilt, B. Cuperus, 1928. HIDDEMANN, Heinrich, 1904- *Die Deformitaten des Unterkiefers und ihre chirur- gische Behandlung. 36p. 8? Bonn [n. pub.] 1933. HIDDEN, Edward S. Edward S. Hidden and some fakes; tonic, obesity cure, and hair grower subjects of Federal actions. J. Am. M. Ass, 1941, 117:2188. HIDE. See also Anthrax (industrial; Prevention); Leather; Skin. Kononenko, A. P. [Disinfection of raw hides] Sovet. vet, 1940, 17: No. 10, 57.—Lipatov, G. I., & Rasovskaia, R. T. [Examination of frozen hides] Ibid, No. 11, 102.—Vass, I. [Regulation of sale of raw hides] Allatorv. lap, 1936, 59: 353-7. HIDEBOUND. See also Cattle, Disease. Coh'er, W. A. Zur Kenntnis einer als Enteque bezeichneten Krankheit der Rinder in der Provinz Buenos Aires. Zschr. Infektkr, 1927, 31: 81-92.—Descazeaux, J. Contribution k l'etude de l'enteque. Bull. Soc. path, exot. Par, 1926, 19: 133-40. HIDRADENITIS. See also Perspiratory gland, Disease. Schonekess, M. *Ueber Schweissdrusen- entziindungen und Abscesse der Achselhohle und iiber ihre Behandlung mit Rontgenstrahlen. 23p. 8? [Lpz.] 1928. Schulz, L. A. *Ueber Schweissdriisen und Schweissdriisenabszesse insbesondere der Achsel- hohle [Freiburg i. B.] 40p. 8? Furstenwalde, 1926. Audry, C. Troubles fonctionnels et maladies inflammatoires des glandes sudoripares. In Nouv. prat. derm. (Darier, Sa- bouraud [et al.]) Par, 1930, 7: 241-74.—Binkley, G. W. Hidradenitis axillaris (Verneuil) Arch. Derm. Syph, Chic, 1937, 35: 745.—Brunsting, H. A. Hidrosadenitis suppurativa (abscess of the apocrine sweat gland) Proc. Mayo CUn, 1937, 12: 753. ■------ Hidradenitis suppurativa; abscess of the apocrine sweat glands; a study of the cUnical and pathologic features, with a report of 22 cases and a review of the literature. Arch. Derm. Syph, Chic, 1939. 39: 108-20.—Campbell, H. S. Hidradenitis suppurativa. Ibid, 1942, 45: 181.—Costello. M. J. Hidradenitis suppurativa. Ibid, 1941, 43: 1050.—Epstein, N. N, & Levin, E. A. Hidradenitis suppurativa. Ibid, 1939, 39: 572.—Koch, F. Zur Histogenese und Pathogenese des Schweissdriisenabszesses. Deut. med. Wschr, 1937, 63: 965- 7.—Lane, J. E. Hidrosadenitis axillaris of Verneuil. Arch. Derm. Syph, Chic, 1933, 28: 009-14.—Ludy, J. B., & Drant, P. Hidradenitis suppurativa, papulonecrotic tubercuUd and bromoderma. Ibid, 1941, 44: 494.—Macey, H. B. AxiUary hidrosadenitis suppurativa; report of case. Proc. Mayo Clin, \94}' i.6: 758.—Novy, F. G, jr. Hidradenitis suppurativa! Arch. Derm. Syph, Chic, 1939, 40: 502.—Polya, J. [Hidro- adenitis suppurativa axillaris] Orv. hetil, 1937, 81: meU, 199— Tachau, P. Abscesses of the sweat glands in adults. Arch Derm. Syph, Chic, 1939, 40: 595-600.—Vrijman, L. H. Hidradenitis suppurativa. Acta derm, vener, Stockh, 1941, 22: 284.—Wien, M. S. Hidradenitis suppurativa. Arch. Derm. Syph, Chic, 1940, 42: 1142. ---- Treatment. Zischank, J. *Die heutigen Anschauungen uber die Behandlung eitriger Schweissdrusen- entziindungen der Achselhohle. 36p. 8? Munch., 1935. Astakhova, N. T., & Dolgova, D. G. [Cold mercury-quartz lamp in the treatment of hidradenitis] Fizioterapia, Moskva, 1941, No. 2, 65.—Axhausen, G. Eigenblutunterspritzung gegen Schweissdriisenabszesse. Med. Welt, 1927, 1: 426-8. ------ Zur Behandlung der rezidivierenden Schweissdrusenentzilndun- gen der Achselhohle. Zbl. Chir, 1928, 55: 212-4.—Capaldi, B. Beitrag zur Kurzwellentherapie der Hydroadenitis. Ibid, 1932, 59: 2926-31.—Fried, C. Radioterapia das hidradenites. Rev. cir. S. Paulo, 1941-42, 7: 187-95.—Goldschmidt, W. Ueber die Behandlung der Schweissdrusenentziindung. Wien. klin. Wschr, 1928, 41: 705—Hoche, O, & Moritsch, P. Zur Behandlung der Schweissdriisenabszesse. Deut. Zschr. Chir, 1926, 199: 326-9.—Macey, H. B. Surgical treatment of axillary hidrosadentitis suppurativa. Am. J. Surg, 1941, 54: 643-7. HIDRADENOMA. See under Perspiratory gland. HIDROA. See also Photosensitization; Porphyria. Jausion, H, Cailliau, F, & Thevenot, S. Sur une epizootie massive autour de 2 cobayes inocuies d'hydroa vesiculeux. Bull. Soc. fr. derm, syph, 1938, 45: 839-55.—Molesworth, E. H. Hidroa or hydroa? Brit. J. Derm. Syph, 1942, 54: 59. ---- aestivalia. See subheading vacciniformia. ---- buccal. Gate, J, Racouchot, J, & Delbos, J. Hydroa buccal avec manifestations pharyngo-laryngees. Bull. Soc. fr. derm, syph, 1937, 44: 499.—Hennion. Presentation d'un malade atteint, d'hydroa buccal. Rev. stomat. Par, 1937, 39: 707.—Martin, A. Un cas d'hydroa bucco-pharyngo-oesophagien. Ann. otolar. Par, 1937, 136.—P6touraud, C, & Dugois, P. Hydroa buccal k repetition chez une malade ayant une langue phcaturee fissuraire. Bull. Soc. fr. derm, syph, 1934,41: 356.—Tesseraux. Ueber eine ulzerose Pharyngo-Laryngitis bei Hydroa vaccini- formis. Arch. Derm. Syph, Berl, 1931, 164: 661-74. ---- infantum. See Erythroderma. ---- vacciniformia. Roller, M. [J.] *Ein Beitrag zur Kenntnis der Hydroa vacciniforme. 28p. 8? Miinch., 1935. Krause, H. U. *Beitrage zu der Lehre von der Hydroa aestivale. 38p. 8? Konigsb., 1927. Steglich, O. *Hydroa aestivale [Leipzig] 43p. 8? Zeulenroda, 1932. Anderson, N. P. Hydroa vacciniforme. Arch. Derm. Syph, Chic, 1939, 39: 889.—Ashby, H. T. Haematoporphyria congenita (congenital porphyrinuria) its association with hydroa vacciniforme and pigmentation of the teeth. Q. J. Med, Oxf, 1925-26, 19: 375-9.—Blum, H. F, & Hardgrave, L. E. Spectral region of photosensitivity in hydroa aestivale seu vacciniforme with porphyrinuria. Proc. Soc. Exp. Biol, N Y 1936 34: 613-5.—Boraa, G. Hydroa aestivalia. Zbl. Haut "Geschlkr, 1938, 60: 593—Borzow, M. W. Drei Falle von Hydroa vacciniforme mit Erscheinungen seitens der Hypophyse. Arch. Derm. Syph, Berl, 1933, 168: 534-47 — Capurro R. Un caso de hidroa vacciniforme. Arch. lat. amer. pediat, B. Air, 1927, 3. ser, 21: 159—Carrie, C. Experimentelle Untersuchungen zum Hydroa vacciniforme und zur Porphyrinurie. Arch. Derm. Syph, Berl, 1931, 163: 523-43 —Davis, H. Two cases of summer eruption. Proc. R Soc' M, Lond, 1911-12, 5: Derm. Sect, 206.—Dowling, G B Acquired hydroa aestivale with haematoporphynnuna. Ibid 1935-36, 29: 98.—Epstein, S. Experimentelle Eruption bei Hydroa vacciniformis durch Thorium X, Arch. Derm. HIDROA 646 HIELSCHER Syph., Berl, 1933, 168: 67-87.—Gray, A. M. H. Haemato- porphyria congenita with hydroa vacciniforme and hirsuties. Q. J. Med, Oxf, 1925-26, 19: 381-92, pl.—Griffith, G. M. Hydroa aestivale. Proc. R. Soc. M, Lond, 1935-36, 29: 1638.—Gulbinas, A. [Case of hydroa vacciniformis] Medicina, Kaunas, 1938, 19: 833-8.—Haussmann, W. Rapports entre la porphyrinurie, la sensibiUte k la lumiSre etl'hydroa estivale (hvdroa vacciniforme de Bazin) Ann. Inst, actin. Par, 1933-34, 8: No. 5, 13-5. ------& Kuen, F. M. Del rapporto della porfirinuria coUa sensibilita, alia luce dell'idroa estiva e successive ricerche sulla sensibilizzazione neU'ultravioletto. Biochim. ter. sper, 1934, 21: 445-8.—Hoffmann, E. Ueber den Erbgang der Hydroa vacciniforme. Arch. Derm. Syph, Berl, 1928, 155: 269. Also Derm. Zschr, 1928, 53: 301-9. ------ Ueber eine einfache Reaktion im Harn bei Hydroa vacciniformis calcificans (Rotfarbung mit 20 proz. Sulfosali- cylsiiuree) KUn. Wschr, 1936, 15: 1553.—Hornyanszky, K. [Hidroa vacciniformia] Orv. hetil, 1929, 73: 1237-40 — Jausion, H, & Guillaud-Vallee, Y. Deux cas d'hydroa vesi- culeux provoquees par le soleil. BuU. m6d. Par, 1933, 47: 219-21.—Klitzner. Hydroa vacciniforme. Derm. Wschr, 1941, 112: 232.—Lehman, C. F, & Pipkin, J. L. Hydroa aestivale vacciniforme. Arch. Derm. Syph, Chic, 1935, 31: 606-8.—Maynard, M. T. R. Hydroa vacciniforme. Ibid, 1939, 39: 1062.—Moro. Hydroa vacciniformis. Khn. Wschr, 1935, 14: 1700.—Newman, C. Porphyrinuria and hydroa aestivale. Proc. R. Soc. M, Lond.. 1935-36, 29: 47.—Peachey, C. H., Dobriner, K. & Strain, W. H. Hydroa estivale in congenital porphyria in a case with purplish brown teeth and hirsuties. N. York State J. M., 1938, 38: 848-56.—Polano, M. K. [Hydroa vacciniformis sanata] Ned. tschr. geneesk, 1940, 84: 2300.—Pozzo, A. Osservazioni su un caso di hydroa vacciniforme. Gior. ital. derm, sif, 1935, 76: No. 3, Suppl, 268-73.—Rille. Hydroa vacciniformis oder vacciniforme? Arch. Derm. Syph, Berl, 1938, 177: 122-4.—Sandbacka- Holmstrom, I. [Hydroa vacciniforme] Nord. med, 1939, 1: 628.—Sftriteanu, F. E, & Teodorescu, S. [Cases of hydroa vacciniforme (Bazin)] Rev. st. med. Bucur, 1927, 16: 609- 28.—Schmidt-La Baume, F. Ein besonders exzessiver Fall von Hydroa vacciniforme. Arch. Derm. Syph, Berl, 1927, 153: 369-74.—Scolari, E. G. Ricerche ed osservazione suU'hy- droa vacciniforme. Gior. ital. derm, sif, 1933, 74: 241-74.— Sechi, E. Sopra un caso di hydroa vacciniforme del Bazin. Dermosifilographo, 1932, 7: 440.—Sellei, J. [Pathogenesis of hidroa vacciniforme seu aestivale] Orv. hetil, 1936, 80: 851-3. Also Arch. Derm. Syph, Berl, 1936, 174: 177-81.—Sparacio, B. Sopra un caso di hydroa vacciniforme. Arch. ital. derm. Bif, 1925-26, 1: 293; 1927-28, 3: 239.—Stein, R. O. Neue Befunde bei Hydroa vacciniforme. Arch. Derm. Syph, Berl, 1928, 155: 270-2.—Stokes, W. H. Ocular manifestations in hydroa vacciniforme. Arch. Ophth, Chic, 1940, 23: 1131- 45.—Tzanck, A, & Pautrat. J. Hydroa vacciniforme. In Nouv. prat. derm. (Darier, Sabouraud, et al.) Par, 1936, 7: 418-26.—Ueberschar. Hydroa aestivaUs (bullose Varietiit) Epidermolysis bullosa hereditaria? Arch. Derm. Syph, Berl, 1926, 151: 343.—Urbach, E, & Bloch, J. Hydroa vacciniforme, Porphyrinopathie, Hepatopathie. Wien. klin. Wschr, 1934, 47: 527-32.—Valoquia. Hidroa vacciniforme. Mem. Congr. med. nac. mex, 1910, 4. Congr, 449-52.—Vigne, P., & Lom- bard, R. Hydroa vacciniforme, forme k evolution chronique, cicatrices atrophiques et keratosiques. MarseiUe med, 1938, 75: 129-34.—Wendlberger, J. Zur Pathologie und Therapie der Hydroa vacciniformis. Arch. Derm. Syph, Berl, 1938, 177:124-8.------& Klein, A. Ueber Hydroa vacciniformis. Ibid, 1937-38, 176: 522-34.—Zelmanovich, A. S., & Borzov, M. V. [Study of hidroa vacciniformia] Tr. Gosud. nauch. inst. fizioter. Semashko, 1934, 2: 215-29. HIDROCYSTOMA. See under Perspiratory gland. HIEROMANIA. See Religion, Psvchosis. HIEBER, Rudolf, 1892- *Nervoeidin (Dalma) und seine Verwendbarkeit als Dentin- anaesthetikum. 18p. 8? Heidelb., J. Horning, 1926. *' HIEGE, Willi, 1900- *Die Beziehungen des Lungenluftungsvermogens zu Korperbau und Korperfunktion. 40p. 8? Marb., J Hamel, 1927. HIELSCHER, Helen Hughes. 1868-1935. [Obituary] J. Lancet, 1935, 55: 391. HIELSCHER, Margarete, 1899- *Die Unfruchtbarmachung Schwachsinniger aus ras- senhygienischen und sozialen Grunden [Jenal p.80-109. 8? Berl., J. Springer, 1930. .Also Arch. Psychiat, Berl, 1930, 90: HIELSCHER, Rudolf, 1910- *Ein Bei- trag zur Frage der Bedeutung des chronischen Gelenkrheumatismus in der Invalidenversiche- rung und der Beurteilungen von Antriigen auf Heilverfahren im Rahmen der Landesversiche- rungsanstalt Schlesien. 34p. 8? Bresl., K Voter, 1938. HIEN, August, 1906 * Ueber blut- drucksteigernde Mittel. 25p. S? Giessen, 1< Glagow, 1932. HIERONLVIUS, Warner, 1909 *Die Grosse der Gaumentonsillen in den verschiede- nen Lebensaltern. 16p. 8? Rostock, C. Hins- torff, 1935. HIERONYMUS, Friedrich Joseph, 1908 *Begunstigt die Salvarsanbehandlung das Auf- treten von Metallsulfidsaumen? [Frankfurt] 48p. 8? Bodenheim-Rhein, Handel, 1934. HIERONYMUS Vicecomes. Lamiarum sivc strigarum opusculum. 24 1. sm. 4? Milano Leonhard Pachel, Sept. 13, 1490. HIESTERMANN, Eugenie, 1908- *Un- tersuchungsergebnisse der Zahn- und Mundver- haltnisse bei den Berufsschulerinnen und B. D. M. Gross-Oberhausen unter Berucksichtigung der sozialen Einfliisse [Munster] 18p. 8° Bottrop, W. Postberg, 1935. HIESTERMANN, Karl, 1903- *Ueber die antiketogene Wirkung der Lactose und Galaktose [Gottingen] 23p. 8? Prenzlau, C Vincent, 1930. HIGBEE, Chester Goss, 1835-1908. Eckman, J. Homeopathic and eclectic medicine in Minne- sota; certain homeopathic and eclectic pioneers. Minnesota M, 1941, 24: 969. HIGBEE, Edward Henry, jr, 1874-1927. Obituary. J. Am. M. Ass, 1927, 89: 1533. HIGGINS, Charles Clair, 1897- [Biography] J. Omaha CUn. Soc, 1941, 2: 110, portr. HIGGINS, Hubert, 1869- Biological re- version and Hippocratic anatomy. x, 149p. 8? Lond,. H. K. Lewis & co., 1929. HIGGINS, S. E. Quiz-book on chemistry and urinalysis for college students and practicing physicians; being a series of questions and an- swers with illustrative experiments essential to a practical knowledge of these subjects. 152p. 5 1. 8? Des Moines, 1902. ---- A brief outline of the muscles, nerves and arteries of the human body. 160p. 16? Howell, Mich., Herald Print, co. [1904] HIGGINS, William [1766]-1825. Reilly, J., & MacSweeney, D. T. William Higgins, a pioneer of the atomic theory. Sc. Proc. R. Dublin Soc, 1928-29, 19: 139-57. HIGGINSON, Charles Gaskell, 1858-1927. Obituary. Lancet, Lond, 1927, 2: 90. HIGHET, Hugh Campbell, 1867-1929. Obituary. Brit. M. J, 1929, 2: 328. HIGH-FREQUENCY current. See under Diathermy; Electric current; Short wave. HIGHMAN, Walter James, 1879-1934. Hoffmann, R. H. [Obituary] J. Mount Sinai Hosp, 1934, 1: 140. Also Arch. Derm. Syph, Chic, 1934, 29: 719. HIGHWAY. Del Mazo, M. Calzadas suburbanas. Congr. argent. urbanismo (1935) 1937, 1. Congr, 2: 163-76.—Fourth (The) Pan American Highway Congress. Bull. Panamer. Union, 1941, 75: 527.—James, E. W. More highways for the Americas: the fourth Pan American Highway Congress. Ibid, 677-81.— Roadside eating places important. Week. Bull. CaUfornia Dep. Pub. Health, 1942-43, 21: 1. HIGIER, Stanislas. Les fonctions sexuelles males et leurs troubles; introduction a la clinique de l'impuissance. 4 p. 1. vii, 391p. illust. 8? Par., G. Doin & cie, 1932. HIGLEY 647 HILDEBRAND HIGLEY, Lester Bodine. See Brauer, J. C, Higley, L. B, & Boyd, J. D. Dentistry for chUdren. 373p. 23Hcm. Phila, 1939. HIGOUMENAKIS, Georges. Le bouton d'Orient (leishmaniose cutanee) et son traite- ment moderne. vi, 149p.; lp. illust. 8? Par., Masson & cie, 1930. HIILIVIRTA, Eino, 1885- *Beitrage zur Anatomie und Histologie der Harnblase der Haussaugetiere [Leipzig] 58p. 11 pl. 8? Dresd., Giintz Stiftung, 1911. HUMANS van den Bergh, Albert Abraham, 1869- See Nolen, W, Hijmans Bergh, A. A., & Heukelom, J. Lebensversicherungs-Medizin. 368p. 8? Berl, 1925. For biography see Ned. tschr. geneesk, 1937, 81: 239, portr. (K. F. Wenckebach) HILAIRE, Gaston Jean Desire, 1906- *Le lichen plan lineaire. 52p. 8? Par., Jouve & cie, 1930. HILBERATH, Hans, 1911- *Ueber einen Fall von recidivierendem Hypopyon, langere Zeit nach erfolgter Staroperation. 20p. 21cm. Wiirzb., C. J. Becker, 1936. HILBERT, Hortense. See National Organization for Public Health Nursing. Survey of pubUc health nursing. 262p. 8? N. Y., 1934. HILBERT, Use [Katharina] 1910- *Ueber den Zusammenhang zwischen der sozialen Lage und den Zahnreihen- und Kieferanomalien bei den Schulkindern Bochums [Greifswald] 19p. 3 ch. 8? Zeulenroda, B. Sporn, 1936. HILBERT, Kurt [Leonhardt Waldemar] 1900- *Superinfektion (Ulcus mixtum) bei einem Fall von tertiarer Lues [Jena] 22p. 8? [Zeulen- roda, A. Oberreuter] 1925. HILBLE, Maria Mathilde, 1906- *Stoff- wechselstorungen . bei Eklampsie [Munchen] 33p. 21cm. Ichenhausen, J. Wagner, 1937. HILBRIG, Walter, 1903- *Die Entwick- lung der Orthodontie von ihren ersten Anfangen bis zu N. W. Kingsley, nach 'Orthodontics; an historical review of its origin and evolution, by Bernhard Wold Weinberger, New York City' [Leipzig] 59p. 8? Dresd., C. C. Meinhold & Sohne, 1928. HILD, Andre Gustave, 1912- *Contribu- tion a l'etude des kystes medians et fistules medianes du cou, par persistance du canal thyreoglosse [Strasbourg] 44p. 24cm. Colmar, Alsatia, 1938. _ , , HILD, Anton M., 1906- *Der Krebsbe- griff bei Theophrastus Paracelsus [Munster] 35p. 21cm. Lengerich, Lengerich. Handelsdr., 1938. HILD, Walter, 1908- *Vergleichende Untersuchungen iiber acetylcholinpositive und -negative Milchsaurebakterien [Heidelberg] 22p. 4 tab. 21cm. Kaiserslautern, P. Pfeiffer [1936] HILDEBRAND, Gustav Yngve. Studies in the masticatory movements of the human lower jaw. 190p. 8? Berl., W. DeGruyter & co., 1931. Forms Suppl. v.61, Skand. Arch. Physiol, Berl. See also Hellner, E. To G. Y. Hildebrand. Acta odont. scand, 1941, 3: 1, portr. HILDEBRAND, Hans Dietrich, 1903- *I)ie Bedeutung des Akonitin in der Medizin. 28p. 8? Berl. [n. pub.] 1933. HILDEBRAND, Helmut, 1910- *Der Einfluss der Moorbadekur auf den Stoffwechsel des saureloslichen ultrafiltrablen Serumeisens und die Viscositat des Blutes bei Adnexitis [Frank- furt] 20p. 8? Torgau, A. Nitschke, 1933 HILDEBRAND, Irma, & JACOBS, H. H. Protests against medical tyranny and vivisec- tional medicine* 12p. 8? N. YM New York Anti-Vivisection Soc, [192-] HILDEBRAND, Joel H[enry] 1881- Pnnciples of chemistry. 161p. 8? Berkeley, Lederer, Street & Zeus co., 1917. See also Latimer, W. M, & Hildebrand, J. H. Reference book of inorganic chemistry. Rev. ed. 563p. 22cm. N. Y, 1940. HILDEBRAND 0[tto] 1858-1927. Grundriss der chirurgisch-topographische.n Anatomie, mit Einschluss der Untersuchungen am Lebenden. 4. Aufl. xvi, 272p. 4? Miinch., J. F. Bergmann, 1924. For Festschrift see Arch. klin. Chir, 1927, 145: portr. For biography see Arch. klin. Chir, 1927, 149: p. i. (W. Korie) Also Deut. med. Wschr, 1927, 53: 2040 (F. Rosen- bach) Also Fortsch. Med, 1927, 45: pt 2, 495 (Siedamgrotzky) Also Klin. Wschr, 1927, 6: 2311 (F. Schuck) Also Med. Welt, 1927, 1: 1506 (H. Picard) Also Munch, med. Wschr, 1928, 75: 179, portr. (O. Stahl) Also Schweiz. med. Wschr, 1928, 58: 107 (Hagenbach) Also Zschr. arztl. Fortbild, 1927, 24: 783 (A. Hubner) HILDEBRAND [Siegfried] Werner, 1907- *Zur Mechanopathologie des Huftgelenks (auf Grund einer Lahmung des Nervus obturatorius) 39p. 8? Lpz., M. Fischer, 1935. HILDEBRANDT, Alwin, 1906- *Ueber die Behandlungsmoglichkeiten der Struma mali- gna und ihre Endausgange [Frankfurt a. M.] p.263-314. roy. 8? Lpz., G. Thieme, 1931. Also Erg. med. Strahlenforsch, 1931, 5: HILDEBRANDT, Christa, 1913- *Kar- zinomentwicklung auf Lichen ruber. 17p. tab. 23cm. BerL, R. Pfau, 1939. HILDEBRANDT, Ekhard [Armin Herwart] 1906- *Ueber die durch Pflanzen hervorge- rufehen Dermatosen. 40p. 8? Berl., Bergdr., 1931. HILDEBRANDT, Fritz, 1897- *Vier Falle von Dystrophia muscularis progressiva. 20p. 8? Kiel, K. J. Rossier, 1926. HILDEBRANDT, Heinz, 1912- *Ueber den Einfluss physikalischer Massnahmen auf die Innentemperatur des menschlichen Magens. 17p. 23cm. BerL, R. Pfau, 1938. HILDEBRANDT, Kurt [Florentin] 1881- Gesundheit und Krankheit in Nietzsches Leben und Werk. 159p. 8? BerL, S. Karger, 1926. Forms H. 38, Abh. Neur. Psychiat. HILDEBRANDT, Wilhelm, 1878-1934. Ras- senmischung und Krankheit; bearb. von H. Herling. 122p. pl. diagr. 8? Stuttg., Hippo- krates, 1935. For biography see Miinch. med. Wschr, 1934, 81: 684 (P. Berggreen, & F. Kuhlman) HILDEBRANDT, Wilhelm [Theodor] 1908- *Ueber den Einfluss der sportlichen Arbeit auf die Kreatininausscheidung mit dem Harn. 16p. 9 tab. 22cm. Rostock, G. Neumann, 1936. HILDEGARD von Bingen, Saint [abbatissa Bingiensis] 1098-1179. Ursachen und Behand- lung der Krankheiten; causae et curae, transl. by Hugo Schulz. 2 p. 1. 235p. 8° Munch., O. Gmelin, 1933. _, , See also Hattemer, M. Geschichte und Erkrankung der Hildegard von Bingen. Hippokrates, Stuttg, 1930-31, 3: 125-49 —Kilmer, F. B.f & Dooley, J. I. A saint among the drugs. Am. J. Pharm, 1927, 99: 727-48.—Restel. L. Die heilige Hildegard von Bingen, die erste deutsche Aerztin und Naturforscherin. Deut. Heilpflanze, 1934-35, 1: 123-5.— Schweisheimer, W. Saint Hildegard of-Bingen; the twelfth century author of Causae et curae. Med. Rec, N. Y., 1941, 153: 243-5. HILDEGART. Malthusismo y neomalthusis- mo; el control de la natalidad. 2 p. 1. 279p. 12? Madr., J. Morata, 1932. HILDENBEUTEL, Georg Johannes, 1913- *Was bedeutet der Verlust eines Zahnes fiir die Funktion des Gesamtgebisses? 24p. 23cm. BerL, K. & R. Hoffmann, 1938, )48 HILGENFELDT HILDENBRAND HILDENBKAND. Anneliese, 1912 *Pharmakol<>ta-che Bch.ichtung der Zahn- und Mundpflegemittel | Tubingen] 21 p. S? Diis- seld., G. H. Nolte, 1937. HILDENBRAND, Ernst G«M>rg. 1910 *Beitrag zur Entstehung der Tuberkulose des Kalbes bis zum Alter von 4 Wochen nach Unter- suchungen am Stadt ischen Schlachthof Giessen [Giessen] 44p. .8° Dornstettcn, K. Zeeb, 1936. HILDERAND [Adolf Wilhelm] Erich, 1893- *Persistenz der Milchzahne, ein Degenerations- zeichen (Auszug.) lOp. 8? [Lpz., n. pub.] 1923. HILDESHEIM, Germ. Adam. Altes und neues aus der Stadt des tausendjahrigen Rosenstockes. Schles. Aerzte-Corresp, 1901, 4: 179-85. HILDITCH, Thomas Percy, 1886- A concise history of chemistry. 2. ed., rev. xi, 276p. diagr. 19cm. Lond., Methuen & co. [1922] ---- The chemical constitution of natural fats, xi, 438p. illust. tab. 25cm. N. Y., J. Wilev & sons, 1940. HILDRETH, Arthur Grant, 1863- The lengthening shadow of Dr Andrew Taylor Still. xiii, 464p. pl. portr. facs. 23^cm. Macon, Mo., 1938. HILDT, Eugene, 1N65- 1926. Necrologie. Ann. falsif. Par, 1926. 19: 517. HILENBERGAS, Judelis, 1911- *Lcs caracteres sexuels secondaires en zoutivhnie. 58p. 8? Lyon, Bose freres, 1936. HILER, Wolf, 1908- *Les hematuries de la fievre tvphoide. 48p. 8? Par., L. Rod- stein, 1934. HILFIKER, Karl. *Die schizophrene Ichauf- losung im All [Zurich] 36p. 8? BerL, W. de Gruyter & co., 1927. Also Allg. Zschr. Psychiat, 1927, 87: HILFSTEIN, Heinrich, 1899- *Ueber die Einwirkung der Glutarsaure auf die leuco- zyten-senkende Wirkung des Phloridzins. 15p. 8? BerL, R. Dammert, 1926. HILGARD, Ernest Ropiequet, 1904- Con- ditioned eyelid reactions to a light stimulus based on the reflex wink to sound, v, 50p. 2 pl. 8? Princeton, N. J., 1931. Forms No. 1, v.41, Psychol. Monogr, Princeton. ---- & MARQUIS, Donald George. Condi- tioning and learning, xi p.; 429p. pl. plan. diagr. 21cm. X. Y., D. Appleton-Century co. [1940] HILGARD, Josephine Rohrs, 1906- The effect of early and delayed practice on memory and motor performances studied by the method of co-twin control, p.493-567. 8? Worcester, Clark Univ., 1933. Forms No. 6, v. 14, Genet. Psychol. Monogr. HILGE, Fritz, 1892- *Die Elliotsche Trepanation beim Glaukoma simplex (Auszug) lOp. 8? [Bonn, n. pub.] 1921. HILGE, Hermann, 1910- *Die Reaktion des Blutbildes auf prophylaktische Injektionen mit Keuchhustenvaccine. 18p. Si? Weende, F. Pieper, 1936. HILGENBERG, Horst, 1912 *Die Gas- narkose und die Erfahrungen, die an der Chir- urgischen Universitatsklinik der Charite mit ihr gemacht wurden. 53p. 8? BerL, K. & R. Hoffmann [19381 HILGENFELD, Helmut, 1907- * Ueber toetalen Hydrocephalus und sein geburtshilfliche Bedeutung [Breslau] 19p. 8? Wiirzb., K Triltsch, 1935. HILGENFELDT, Otto, 1900- *Ein Bei- trag zur Kenntnis der ZungenKcschwiilste des Kindcsallcis (Auszug) 8p. 8? Lpz, V Edelmann, 1925. HILGENSTOEHLER, Martin, 1912 *Beitrage zur Frage der Aetiologie und klinischen Bedeutung der verlnngerten P-Q Strcikc im Elektrokardiogramm j Munster] 19p. 21 cm. Lengerich, Lengerich. Handelsdr., 193S. HILGER, Albert, 1S39 1905. [Biography] In Gallerie hervorrag. Ther. Plianmikngn. Gegenwart, Geneve, 1897, 219; 363, portr. HILGER. Karl Heinrich A., IStiS , & HILGER, Wilhelm F. Ambulatory proctology. 57 1. 4? [n. p., n. pub.] 1933. Mimeographed. HILGER, Wilhelm F., 1873- See Hilger, Karl H. A, & Hilger, Wilhelm F. Ambulatory proctology. 57 1. 4? [n. p.] 1933. HILGERING, Regina, 1906- *Ueber die Haufigkeit der Bronchiektasen in Bonn und ihre Erklarung. 37p. 8? Bonn, P. Kubens, 1931. HILGERMANN, Maria, 1910- *Schim- melpilzerkrankungen des Menschen und ihre Therapie. 35p. 8? Bonn, L. Nouendorff, 1934. HILGERMANN, Rfobert] 1874 , & LOS- SEN, J. Diagnostik der Jnfektionskrankhciten mittels bakteriologischer, serologischer, zyto- logischer und chemischer Untersuchungsmetho- den; mit einem Anhang: Die Vakzinetherapie. xii, 499p. 8? Jena, G. Fischer, 1923. HILGERS, Franz, 1910- *Die zahnarzt- liche Versorgung des freien Volksstaates Wurt- temberg und der hohenzollernschen Lande unter besonderer Berucksichtigung der Leistungen der offentlichen Fiirsorge. 38p. 8? Miinst.-Westf., 1934. HILGERS, W[ilhelm] 1885- , JADAS- SOHN, W. [et al.] Erkrankungen der Haut durch Protozoen, filtrierbares Virus, Bakterien; Immunbiologie. ix, 507p. 236 illust. 8? Berl., J. Springer, 1932. Forms Bd 2. Handb. Haut & Geschlechtskr. (Alexander) Berl, 1927-32. HILKER, Harold, 1909- *Oxygen in the treatment of acute coronary occlusion. 9p. Milwaukee, Wis., 1937. Typewritten. HILL, Albert Lyon, 1882- See Fist, Harry S, Hill, Albert L. [et al.] Notes on lectures given at the College of Medical Evangelists, on obstetrics and pediatrics, [v. p.] roy. 8? Los Ang, 1931. HILL, Alex, 1856-1929. Obituary. Lancet, Lond, 1929, 1: 525. HILL, Archibald] Vfivian] 1886- The present tendencies and the future compass of physiological science. 32p. 21}£cm. Lond., Univ. London press, 1923. ----Living machinery; 8 lectures delivered at the Lowell Institute, Boston, March, 1927. xxi, 306p. 12 pl. 8? N. Y., Harcourt, Brace & co. [1927] ---- Muscular movement in man: the factors governing speed and recovery from fatigue. 5 p. 1. 104p. portr. 8? N. Y., McGraw-Hill Book co., 1927. ----Chemical wave transmission in nerve. ix, 74p. illust. diagrs. 8? Cambr., Kng., Univ. press, 1932. ----Living machinery; 6 lectures delivered at the Royal Institution, xiv, 256p. illust. pl. 8? Lond., G. Bell & sons, 1933. For portrait, photograph, see collection in library. HILL, Sir Arthur W„ 1875-1941. Cotton, A. D., Evans, G. [et al.] [Obituary] Nature, Lond, 1941, 148: 619-23.—[Obituary] Lancet, Lond, 1941, 2:612. HILL 649 HILL HILL, Asa, 1815-1874. Thorpe, B. L. Asa Hill, inventor of Hill's stopping, a man who did much to make the preservation of human teeth possible. In. his Biogr. Pioneer Am. Dentists, Chic, 1909, 315-24, portr. HILL, Austin Bradford, 1897 Artificial humidification in the cotton weaving industry; its effect upon the sickness rates of weaving operatives, iv, 73p. 8? Lond., H. M. Stat. Off., 1927. Forms Rep. No. 48, Gr. Britain, Privy Counc, Med. Res. Counc, Indust. Fatigue Res. Bd. ---An investigation into the sickness ex- perience of printers; with special reference to the incidence of tuberculosis, ix, 114p. 8? Lond., H. M. Stat, Off., 1929. Forms Rep. No. 54, Gr. Britain, Privy Counc, Med. Res. Counc, Indust. Fatigue Res. Bd. ---- Sickness amongst operatives in Lanca- shire Cotton Spinning Mills (with special refer- ence to workers in the cardroom) xi, 91p. 8? Lond., H. M. Stat. Off., 1930. Forms Rep. No. 59, Gr. Britain, Privy Counc, Med. Res. Counc, Indust. Health Res. Bd. --- The inheritance of resistance to bacterial infection in animal species; a review of the published experimental data. 71 p. 8? Lond., H. M. Stat. Off., 1934. Forms Spec, Rep. No. 196, Gr. Britain, Privy Counc, Med. Res. Counc. ---An investigation into the sickness ex- perience of London transport workers, with special reference to digestive disturbances, v, 25p. 8? Lond., H. M. Stat. Off., 1937. Forms Rep. No. 79, Gr. Britain, Med. Res. Counc, Indust. Health Res. Bd. --- Principles of medical statistics, vii, 171p. tab. ch. 8? Lond., Lancet, 1937. See also Straker, E, Rosher. A. B. |et al.] A study of the nasopharyngeal bacterial flora [&c] 131p. 8? Lond, 1939. HILL, Benjamin. Rheumatism-arthritis. 26p. 12? [Wilkinsburg, Pa., 1935] HILL, Charles, 1862- A manual of normal histology and organography. 6. ed. p. 1. 518p. 6 pl. 8? Phila., W. B. Saunders co., 1931. Also 7. ed. 530p. illust. pl. 1937. HILL, Charles G., 1849-19—? Johnson, H. W. Presentation of portrait of Dr Charles G. Hill. Tr. Med. & Chir. Fac. Maryland, 1925, 127: 235. HILL, David Spence, 1873- The li- braries of Washington; a study of the govern- mental and non-governmental libraries in the District of Columbia in relation to the units of government and other organizations which they serve, xvi, 296p. roy. 8? Chic, Am. Libr. Ass., 1936. HILL, Douglas William, 1904- , & HOW- ITT, Frederick Oliver. Insulin; its production, purification and physiological action, xi, 219p. pl. tab. diagr. 8? [Lond.] Hutchinson Sc. Pub., 1936. Also American edition. HILL, Earl Vernon. Aerology for amateurs and others; air conditioning fundamentals and test methods. Pt 1, Chap. 2: Development dur- ing present century. 35p. 8? Chic, Aerologist Pub. co. [1931] —— The same, Pt 2, Chap. 1 : Temperature, humiditv and air motion and distribution. 31p. 8? Chic, Aerologist Pub. co. [1931] — The same. Pt 2, Chap. 3: Bacteria, odors, and carbon dioxide. 19p. 8? Chic, Aerologist Pub. co. [1931] ---The same. Pt 2, Chap. 5: The psychro- metric chart. 29p. illust. pl. 8? Chic, Aero- logist Pub. co., 1932. HILL, Eben Clayton, 1882-1940. Obituary. J. Am. M. Ass, 1940, 115: 398. HILL, Emory, 1883-1940. Courtney, R. H. Obituarv. Am. J. Qphth 1941 24- 212-4, portr.—[Obituary] J. Am. M. Ass, 1941. 116- 245 — Tucker, B. R, Rucker, M. P., & Courtney, R. H. [Obitua'rvl Bull. Richmond Acad. M, 1941, 9: 26, porta.-£nta»yer W Obituary. Arch. Ophth, Chic, 1941, 25: 153, portr. HILL. Frank Ernest, 1888- Educating for health; a study of programs for adults ix 224p. 19Mcm. N. Y., Am. Ass. Adult Educ! Forms No. 15, Stud. Social Significance Adult Educ United States. HILL, George William, 1858-1928. G, J. D. Obituary. Brit. M. J, 1928, 2: 1074.—Obituary Lancet, Lond, 1928, 2: 1162. *' HILL, H. M. See Clephan, D. F, & Hill, H. M. An elementary handbook of radium and its cUnical use. 164p. 8? Lond, 1933 HILL, Harry. See Harvey, W. C, & Hill, H. Insect pests. 292p. 19cm Lond, 1940. HILL, Hazel, E. Up-to-date consumers. 16p. 23cm. Durham, 1940. Forms Circ. 224, N. Hampshire Univ. Extens. Serv. HILL, Horace. The histamine and insulin treatment of schizophrenia and other mental diseases, vii, 133p. incl. tab. 19cm. Lond Bailliere, Tindall & Cox, 1940. HILL, James, 1936. Obituary. Glasgow M. J, 1936, 12(>: 289. HILL, J[ames] P[eter] 1873- The de- velopmental history of the Primates, p.45-178. 21 pl. 29cm. Lond., Harrison & sons, 1932. In Philos. Tr. R. Soc. London, 1932, ser. B, 221: ----& FLORIAN, J. A young human embryo, embryo Dobbin, with head-process and pre- chordal plate, p.443-86. 7 pl. 29cm. Lond., Harrison & sons, 1931. In Philos. Tr. R. Soc. London, 1931, ser. B, 219: HILL, James Rufus, 1872- [Biography] N. Orleans M. & S. J, 1934-35, 87: 858, portr. HILL, Sir John, 1716-75. Chenoweth, M. N. The curious case of Sir John Hill. Am. J. Pharm, 1937, 109: 460-3.—Conn, H. J. The history of staining. Stain Techn, 1933, 8: 4-7, portr.—Woodruff, L. I, The versatile Sir John Hill, M. D. Am. Natur, 1926, 60: 417-42, portr. HILL, John, 1895-1940. Obituary. Glasgow M. J, 1940, 134: 54. HILL, John Louis, 1872- Negro, national asset or liability? (The battle of the bloods) 4 p. 1. xi-xiii, 233p. 8? X. Y., Literary Ass. [1930] HILL, John Rutherford, -1941. [Obituary] Pharm. J, Lond, 1941, 93: 43.—Portrait. Q. J. Pharm, Lond, 1938, 11: 338; 1939, 12: Opp. 322. HILL, Justina [Hamilton] 1893- Germs and the man. xvi, 461p. pl. 22cm. N. Y., G. P. Putnam's sons [1940]" HILL, Leonard Erskine, 1866- Coddling children, p.674-481. 8? N. Y. [n. pub.] 1928. ----Philosophy of a biologist, viii, 88p. 12? Lond., E. Arnold & co., 1930. ----Manual of human physiology. 4. ed. xii, 470p. illust. 8? Lond., E. Arnold, 1935, See also Hall, Percy. Ultra-violet rays [&c] 248p. 8! Lond, 1929. ----& CLEMENT, Mark. Common colds; causes and preventive measures. viii, 126p. 6 pl. 8? Lond., W. Heinemann, 1929. HILL, Leonard Erskine, & ELLMAN, Philip. The rheumatic diseases; a course of lectures arranged bv the medical staff of the St John Clinic and "institute of Physical Medicine, xii, 270p. illust. pl. 8? Bait., W. Wood, 1938, i50 HILL HILL HILL, Lewis Webb, 1889- Sco Morse, J. L, Wyman. E. T, A Hill, L. W. The infant and young child. 2. ed. 299p. 8? 1'l.ila, 1929. HILL, Luther Leonidas, 1862- Reminis- cences of 50 years in the medical profession. 23p. N° Montgomery, Ala., Montgomery Co. Med. Soc, 1931. HILL, Matthew Berkeley, 1834-92. [Biography] Cat. Portr. R. Coll. Surgeons, Lond, (930, 30, HILL, Octavia, 1838-1912. I, M. O. Biojrraphv. Nurs. Times, Lond, 1938, 34: l.>73. pnrtr. HILL, Penelope. See Stuart. H. C, Hill, Penelope [et al.] The growth of bone, muscle [etc.] 190p. 23cm. Wash, 1940. HILL, R. G. A fruit and vegetable buying guide for consumers. 61p. 8? Wash., 1933. Forms No. 167, Misc. Pub. U. S. Dep. Agr. HILL, Sir Robert, 1865-1938. Obituary. Brit. M. J, 1938, 1: 980, portr.—Whiteside, H. C. Obituary. J. R. Nav. M. Ser, 1938, 24: 175-7, portr. HILL. Rolla Bennett, 1891- & BENAR- ROCH, E. I. Anquilostomiasis y paludismo en Venezuela. 205p. pl. tab. pt fold. fold, diagr. 23t2cm. Caracas, Editorial Elite, 1940. HILL, Theo, 1906- *Ueber Vaccine- therapie des Keuchhustens [Bonn] 24p. 8? Koblenz, Gorres, 1932. HILL, Thomas B. The classification and education of mentally handicapped children in various countries. 104p. tab. 8? Melb., Melbourne Univ. press, 1937. HILL, Thomas Chittenden, 1871- A manual of proctology. 2. ed. vi, 294p. 8? Phila., Lea & Febiger, 192(1. Also 3. ed. vii, 272p. 1929. HILL, Sir Thomas Eustace, 1865-1931. [Obituary] Brit. M. J, 1931, 2: 1115. Also Lancet, Load, 1931, 2: 1271. HILL, Thomas Joseph. See Bunting, R. W, & Hill, T. J. A text-book of oral pathology. 2. ed. 460p. 24cm. Phila, 1940. HILL, Thomas Rowland, 1903- Con- tributions to clinical practice in medicine and surgery by members of the staff of the Southend General Hospital, v.l. vii, 208p. illust. pl. 8? [Lond.] Southend Gen. Hosp., 1936. ---- Some neurological and psychiatric as- pects of surgery, p.5477-533. 8? [N. Y., 1937] In Postgrad. Surg. (Maingot, R.) N. Y, 1937, 3: ---- Treatment of some common diseases (medical and surgical) by various authors. xv, 398p. incl. illust. tab. diagr. 22cm. Bait., Williams & Wilkins co., 1939. HILL, Thomas Walter. The health of Eng- land. 301 p. illust. pl. maps. 8? Lond., J. Cape [ 1933] HILL, Walter, 1877T1927. Obituary. Med. Press &" Circ, Lond, 1927, n. ser, 123: 532. HILL, Werner [Ernst Max Andreas] 1907- 'Stunipfe Bauchverletzungen; Bericht iiber 56 Falle tin Chirurgischen Klinik an der Uni- versitat in Jena 1921-33 [Jena] 41p. 8? Weimar, G. Uschmann, 1935. HILL, Wilfrid. Cold-free 14 years. 59p. portr. 8? Lond., Joiner & Steele [1935] HILL, William Robinson, & PILLSBURY, Donald Marion. Argyria; the pharmacology of silver. vii, 172p. incl. tab. 23}£cm. Bait., Williams & Wilkins co., 1939. HILL, Wfillard] Wfjlliams] 1902- Navaho warfare. 19p. 25cm. X. Haven, Yale Univ press, 1936. Forms No. 5, Yale Univ. Pub. Anthrop, ----The agricultural and hunting methods of the Navaho Indians. 194p. 4 pl. on 21. 25cm. N. Haven, Yale Univ. press, 1938. forms No. 18, Yale Univ. Pub. Anthrop. HILLA, Josef Joachim, 1909- *Xagcltri- chophytie. 39p. 8? [Bresl., n. pub., 1937| HILLE, Johannes, 1904- ♦Beobachtun- gen iiber Friihdiagnose und Prognose der Lym- phogranulomatose. 16p. 8? Lpz., A. Edel- mann, 1935. HILLE, Karl. *Untersuchungen an Kindern der Ferienheime des See- und Solbades Kolberg (Auszug) 8p. 8? [Rostock, n. pub.] 1923. HILLE, Lenchen, 1909- *Ueber die Einwirkung von Gastrosil auf die Hvperaciditat. 16p. 8? Kiel [n. pub.] 1933-34. HILLE, Willi, 1906- *Schizophrene Er- krankungen im fruhjugendlichen Alter. 39p. 8? Bonn, P. Kubens, 1931. HILLEBRAND, Eduard, 1909- *Ueber Gelenkbinnendruckmessungen an menschlichen Leichengelenken. 15p. 8? Wiirzb., R. Mavr, 1936. HILLEBRAND, Franz, 1863-1926. Lehre von den Gesichtsempfindungen, auf grund hinterlas- sener Aufzeichnungen; hrsg. von Franziska Hillebrand. iv, 205p. 8? Wien, J. Springer, 1929. For biography see Zschr. Psychol. Physiol. Sinnesorg, 1. Abt, 1927, 102: 1-5 (C. Stumpf, & H. Rupp) HILLEBRAND, Franziska. See Hillebrand, Franz. Lehre von den Gesichtsempfind- ungen [&c] 205p. 8? Wien, 1929. HILLEBRAND, Hubert, 1895- *Beitrag zur Histologie der Stiele (der nicht odematosen Abschnitte) der Blasenmolenzotten [Bonn] 8p. 8? BerL, S. Karger, 1921. HILLEBRAND, Josef, 1907- *Die schrage Osteotomie des Calcaneus bei Fuss- deformitaten [Kiel] 15p. 8? Wiirzb., K. Triltsch, 1934. HILLEBRAND, Waldemar, 1911- *Fei- nere Liquorveranderungen bei zerebral-organi- schen Affektionen. 19p. 22cm. Marb., R. Friedrich, 1936. HILLEBRAND, William Francis, 1853-1925. Portrait. Hist. Chem. (Moore, F. J.) 3. ed, N. Y, 1939, 334, HILLEL, Heinrich. Ein Beitrag zur Patholo- gie der Essigsaurevergiftung. 20p. 8? Berl., E. Ebering, 1921. Forms H. 2, Abt. Path, Beitr. Heilk. HILLEMEYER, Franz, 1905- *Darm- wandphlegmonosa auf Grund von Gallenstein- einklemmung im Darm. 22p. 8? BerL, Gebr. Hoffmann, 1933. HILLEN, Hans, 1910- *Ueber den Ein- fluss der Natriumhalogenide auf diastatische Fermente. 15p. 8? Bottrop, W. Postberg, 1935. HILLEN, Marie Jacqueline Wilhelmina, 1894- *Over de bereiding van eenige steriele geneesmiddelen, met inachtneming van hun pharmacologische werking. 125p. roy. 8? Balk (Fr.) [n. pub.] 1925. HILLENBRAND, Fritz, 1907- *Einge- weidewurmer bei Kindern in Rostock. 32p. 8? Rostock, C. Hinstorff, 1935. HILLENBRAND, Karl, 1904- *Ueber subkutane isolierte Pankreasruptur [Freiburg i. B.] 23p. 8? [Kirchhain N.-L., Zahn & Baendel] 1929. HILLENBRAND, Rudolf, 1908- *Beob- achtungen uber Lippen- und Wangenzotten bei Neugeborenen. 23p. 21cm. Wurzb., C. J. Becker, 1938. HILLER 651 HILLS HILLER, Alfons, 1903- *Die unfall- medizinische Beurteilung der Spondylolisthesis [Leipzig] 24p. 8? Zeulenroda, A. Oberreuter, 1937. HILLER, Alfred, 1909- *Zur Frage der Tuberkulose des Collum uteri [Berlin] 40p. 23cm. Charlottenb., K. & R. Hoffmann, 1938. HILLER, Alma, 1892- ♦The effect of histamine on protein catabolism and on acid- base balance [Columbia Univ. J p. 1. 32p. 8? N. Y., 1926. Also J. Biol. Chem, 1926, G8: HILLER, Eduard, 1911 ♦Labyrinther- schiitterung durch indirekte Gewalteinwirkung. 24p. 8? Miinch., F. X. Seitz, 1936. HILLER, Friedrich, 1891- Die Zirkula- tionsstorungen des Ruckenmarks und Gehirns. p.178-465. 8? [BerL, J. Springer, 1936] In Handb. Neur. (Bumke & Foerster) Berl, 1936, Bd 11. --- Organische Nervenkrankheiten. p.412- 650. 8? BerL, J. Springer, 1936. In Lehrb. inn. Med, 3. Aufl, Berl, 1936, Bd 2. --- The same, p.434-677. 25cm. BerL, J. Springer, 1939. In Lehrb. inn. Med, 4. Aufl, Berl, 1939, Bd 2. --- Ruckenmark. p.188-315. 25}^cm. BerL, J. Springer, 1939. In Handb. inn. Med. (G. v. Bergmann, et al.) 3. Aufl, Berl, 1939, Bd 5, T. 1. See also Griinthal, E, Hiller, F. [et al.] Traumatische prasenile und senile Erkrankungen, Zirkulationsstorungen. 548p. 8? Berl, 1936. HILLER, Glenn Ivan. thrombophlebitis: treatment by sympathetic block [Milwaukee Co. Gen. Hosp.] 22p. 28cm. [Wauwatosa] 1940. Typewritten. HILLER, Karl Ludwig Ferdinand, 1912- ♦Fehler und Gefahren bei Behandlung der Trigeminus-Neuralgie [Munchen] 36p. 8? Wiirzb., R. Mayr, 1937. HILLERS, Aletta, 1908- ♦Orale Fokalin- fektion und Hautkrankheiten [Freiburg] 29p. 8? Winsen-Luhe, Gebr. Ravens, 1932. HILLERS, Gertrud, 1900- *Ostitis fi- brosa nach Fraktur. 16p. 2 pl. 8? Miinch., ,C. Wolf & Sohn, 1926. HILLES, Helen Train, 1905- Young food, xiii, 253p. 21cm. N. Y., Duell, Sloan & Pearce [19401 HILLESHEIM, Hanns Bernhard, 1909- *Die Funktion des Innenohres mit Labyrinth- fistel nach Radikaloperation [Giessen] 22p. 8? Griinberg, H. Ritter, 1934. HILLIARD, Curtis Morrison, 1887 A textbook of bacteriologv and its applications. ix, 329p. 8? Bost., Ginn & co., 1928. Also 2. ed. ix, 339p. illust. diagrs. [1936] ■—— The prevention of disease in the com- munity, viii, 193p. 8? N. Y., McGraw-Hill book co., 1931. HILLIER, William Thomas. A theory of the formation of animals, iv p.; 166p. illust. pl. diagrs. 8? Bristol, J. Wright & Sons, 1932. HILLMAN, Oscar Stanley, 1895- Oper- ative surgerv described for nurses, viii, 227p. 8? Lond., Faber & Gwver, 1927. HILLMANN, Gregor,' 1899- *Oophoro- 8? Bresl., Bresl. tomia probatoria. 23p Genoss. Buchdr., 1929. HILLMER, Max, 1901- des Oesophaguscarcinoms. Ebering, 1926. HILLS, James Harvey, Fowler, S. W. [Biography] In his Hist. Med. Delaware County, Del, 1910, 26; 30. ♦Die Metastasen 16p. 8? BerL, E. -1830. HILLS, Ralph, 1810-79. CounTv^De!; So, S-TSS '" ** Hkt Mei B^^ HILLSCHER, Viktor, 1902- ♦Ein Beitrag zur Kasuistik des Blitzstars [Berlin] p 4-19 8? Stuttg., F. Krais, 1933. Also KUn. Mbl. Augenh, 1933, 91: HILLWEG, C[harles] U. A complete mouth survey in detail; meeting the shopper. 13 1 roy. 8° Rochester, N. Y., Ritter Dent. Mfg co., 1935. Typewritten. ---- Fees; when and how to quote. 14 1 roy. 8? Rochester, N. Y., Ritter Dent. Mfg co., 1935. Mimeographed. '----Psychology of equipment. 13 1. roy. 8? Rochester, N. Y., Ritter Dent. Mfg co., 1935. Typewritten. ■—■— Selling; contracting a case. 12 1. roy. 8? Rochester, N. Y., Ritter Dent. Mfeco., 1935. Mimeographed. ---- X-ray; read your textbook of X-ray technique. 9 1. roy. 8? Rochester, N. Y., Ritter Dent. Mfg co., 1935. Mimeographed. ■—— The same. 12 1. roy. 8? Rochester, N. Y., Ritter Dent. Mfg co., 1935. Mimeographed. ---- X-ray, business and fees. 12 1. roy. 8: Rochester, N. Y., Ritter Dent. Mfg co., 1935. Typewritten. ----X-ray presentation. 9 1. roy. 8? Rochester, N. Y., Ritter Dent. Mfg co., 1935. Typewritten. ----X-ray; complete mouth X-ray survey. 9 1. roy. 8? Rochester, N. Y., Ritter Dent. Mfg co., 1935. Mimeographed. ---- Prophylaxis; preventive dental service. 13 1. roy. 8? Rochester, N. Y., Ritter Dent. Mfg co., 1935. Mimeographed. ■—■— Children's dentistry; a supplement to general practice. 6 1. roy. 8? Rochester, N. Y., Ritter Dent. Mfg co., 1936. Mimeographed. HILLYER, Jane. Reluctantly told. xvii, 2 1. 205p. 12? N. Y., Macmillan co., 1926. HILLYER, Virgil Mores, 1875-1931. Child training; a system of education for the child under school age [3. ed.] xiv, 299p. pl. 8? X. Y., D. Appleton-Century [1937] HILMER, Hilde, 1908- ♦Klinische Ka- talasebestimmungen im kindlichen Blut. 28p. 8? Marb., J. A. Koch, 1935. HILMER [Karl Adolf] Wilhelm, 1902- ♦Versuche iiber die Kombination von Novokain und Kaliumphosphat. 14p. 8? Halle [n. pub.] 1931. HILMI, Mansour, 1903- * Prophylaxie des bilharzioses. 35p. 8? Par., A. Legrand, 1934. HILPISCH, Wilhelm, 1911- *Ueber die Beeinflussung der Katalase durch Kurzwellen- und Moorbaderwarmebehandlung [Frankfurt] 19p. -22#cm. Wurzb., R. Mayr, 1938. HILSCHENZ, Joachim. ♦Zur Frage der Ent- ferhungsbestimmung bei Schiissen mit rauch- schwachem Pulver und iiber die Technik des Nachweises von Pulverresten [Munchen] p.235- 64. 8? BerL, J. Springer, 1929. Also Deut. Zschr. gerichtl. Med, 1929-30, 14: HILSMANN (ir>2 HIMES HILSMANN. Josef, 190H- ♦Erfahrungen iiber die Silikose unter besonderer Beriicksichti- gung der 'Kormerkrankbeit' im Wallauer Hiitten- gelu. t. 30|). 8° Marb., O-termnnn, 1932. HILSONT. Philippe, 1904- *Les phe- nomenes de photosensibilisation chez nos ani- maux domestiqups [Alfort] filp. 8? Rouen, Impr. Wolf, 1928. HILTEN, Johan Philip van. +()ver stoornissen in de vetresorptie [Amsterdam] viii, 58p. 8? PuriiuTcnd, J. Muusses & co., 1925. HILTENSPERGER, Josef, 1912- ♦Die Facialisparese bei Heine-Medin'scher Krankheit im Kindesalter und ihre Prognose [Munchen] 19p. 21cm. Wiirzb., K. Triltsch, 1938. HILTON, David Clark, 1877- Dr Hilton retires from National Guard. Nebraska M. J, 1940, 25: 388, portr. HILTON, George. Mange in horses, cattle and sheep. 12p. illust. 8? Ottawa, R. Wier, 1930. Forms No. 31, n. ser. Bull. Canada Dep. Agr. ---- Johne's disease of cattle. op. 8? Ottawa, J. O. Patenaude, 1934. Forms No. 167, n. ser. Bull. Canada Dep. Agr. HILTON, James Franklin, 1879-1941. [Obituary] Med. Ann. District of Columbia, 1941, 10: 203. HILTON, John, IN04-78. On rest and pain: a course ot lectures on the influence of mechanical and physiological rest in the treatment of acci- dents and surgical diseases, and the diagnostic value of pain. 2. ed. xiv, 478p. illust. 12? Lond., G. Bell & sons, 1877. For portraits .see Guv's Husp. Hep, Lond., 1930, 86: 251; 252; 257. For bioprnphy see Cat. Portr. K. Coll. Surgeons, Lond, 1930, 30. Also Lancet, Lond, 1936, 1: 435. HILTON, Reginald, 1895 See Langdon-Brown, Walter, & Hilton, Reginald. Physio- logical principles in treatment. 7. ed. 308p. 8! Bait, 1936. Also Hutchison, Sir R, & Hilton, R. An index of treatment. 12. ed. 996p. 26!^cm. Bristol, 1940. HILTROP, Heinz, 1913- ♦Beitrage zur zahnarztlichen Standesfrage. 44p. 21cm. Bonn, A. Brand. 1937. HILWEG, Hans Dietrich, 1893- *Ueber Tetanus puerperalis [Gottingen] 56p. 8? Grone, A. Schonhiitte & Sohnen, 1927. HILZ, Elisabeth, 1906- ♦Myom als Geburtshindernis [Munchen] 24p. 8? Borna, R. Xoske, 1933. HILZ, Werner, 1907- *Zwei seltene Falle von Lupus erythematodes. 19p. 8? Miinch., C. Wolf & Sohn, 1937. HIMALAYA. Morkis., J. Living with Lepchas; a book about the Sikkim Himalayas. 312p. 22cm. Lond. [1938] HIMASTHLINAE. See under Echinostomidae. HI MEL, Zygmunt. ♦Hypophysare Kachexie mit atypischen Svmptomen. 18p. 23cm. Stet- ten, K. Schahl, 1939. HIM ELF ARB, Jacob, 1904- ♦Les troubles bucco-pharynges dans la leucemie aigue. 31p. 8° Par.. Jouve & cie, 1932. HIMES. Isaac Newton, 1834-95. Dittrick. H. Founder of Cleveland Medical Library. Bull. Acad.-M. Cleveland, 1931, 15: 13-22. HIMES. Norman Edwin, 1899- A guide to birth control literature, a selected bibliography on the technique of contraception and on the social aspects of birth control. 46p. 12? Lond X. Douglas, 1931. Medical history of contraception. xx\i, 521p. illust. diagrs. 8? Bait., Williams & Wilkins co., 1936. Practical birth-control methods, with the medical collaboration of Vbraham Stone [2. print] 8 p. 1. 254p. illust. 20'^cm. Chic, Swift & co. [1939] HINMAN, Robert Byron, & SCHUTT, C. D. Curing meats. 21p. 8? Ithaca, N. Y., 1932. Forms No. 241, Cornell Extens. Bull. HINMAN, Strong, 1893- Physical educa- tion in the elementary grades, viii, 523p. incl. illust. diagr, form. 21cm. N. Y., Prentice- Hall, 1939. HINNEBERG, Karl Heinz, 1908- ♦Un- tersuchungen iiber den Einfluss von Sch'af- mitteln auf die Diuresa [Rostock] 16p. 8° Jena, G. Neuenhahn, 1934. HINRICHS, A. F. Wages in cotton-goods manufacturing, xii, 154p. 23cm. Wash., 1938. Forms Bull. No. 663, U. S. Bur. Labor Statist. HINRICHS 654 HINSDALE HINRICHS, Alfred, 1904- ♦Die per- forierten Magen-Duodenal-Geschwiire an der Gottinger Chirurgischen Klinik, 1900-25. 27p. 8? Gott., Handelsdr., 1927. HINRICHS, Ferdinand, 1908- ♦Erfah- rungen bei der Behandlung des Empyems der Pleurahohle [Diisseldorf] 20p. 8? Emden, B. David, 1935. HINRICHS, Hans, 1910- ♦Ueber die Osteomyelitis des Oberkiefers. 24p. 8? [Kiel, Hav] 1935-36. HINRICHS, Johannes, 1910- ♦Ueber Unterlippencarcinome. 46p. 8? Kiel, Meyer, 1933. HINRICHS, Julius [Wilhelm Heinrich] 1908- ♦Interstitielle Tubargraviditat [Marburg] 24p. 22cm. Diisseld., G. H. Nolte, 1937. HINRICHS, Theodor, 1871-1936. Grabow. Nekrolog. Psychiat. neur. Wschr, 1935, 37: 535. HINRICHS, Uwe Hans, 1901- ♦Dauer- schlafbehandlung mit Skopolamin-Paraldehyd bei Geisteskranken [Kiel] 24p. ch. 8? [Neustadt (Holstein) H. Ehlers] 1927. HINRICHSEN, Elisabeth, 1902- ♦Ueber die Behandlung der Hasenscharten [Berlin] 31p. 8? Lippstadt, Thiele, 1933. HINRICHSEN, Use, 1899- ♦Zur Aetio- logie der Mehrlingsgraviditat. lOp. 8? Miinch. [n. pub.] 1926. HINRICHSEN, Josephine, 1906- Mod- ern serologic tests for syphilis and their inter- pretation by the physician, vii, 81 p. 23cm. Wash., Gov. Print. Off., 1941. Forms Suppl. 14, Vener. Dis. Inform. HINRICHSEN, Mathilde [geb. Krause] 1897- ♦Ueber primare freie Fettgewebstrans- plantation bei schweren Gelenkfrakturen. 28p. 8? [BerL, n. pub.] 1930. HINRICHSEN, Rolf W[illi] 1910- +Zur Hasenschartenvererbung. 24p. 8° Kiel, Leuch- tenberg, 1935. HINSBERG, Karl, 1894- Medizinisch- chemische Bestimmungsmethoden: Darstellung der allg«mein gebrauchlichen und wichtigsten quantitativen Methoden; eine Auswahl von Methoden fiir das klinische Untersuchungslabo- ratorium. 2v. vi, 93p.; v, 186p. illust. tab. ch. 8° BerL, J. Springer, 1935-36. ----& LANG, K. Medizinische Chemie fiir den klinischen und theoretischen Gebrauch. viii, 458p. illust. tab. 24}£cm. BerL, Urban & Schwarzenberg, 1938. HINSBERG, Viktor, 1870-1933. Beck, K. Nekrolog. Zschr. Laryng, 1933-34, 24: 486.— Klestadt, W. Nekrolog. Mschr. Ohrenh, 1933, 67: 1149-53 — Ropke. Nekrolog. Zschr. Hals &c. Heilk, 1933, 35: p. i-iv.— Wittmaack, K. Nekrolog. Arch. Ohr. &c. Heilk, 1933-34, 137: 1-6. HINSCHBERGER, Georges Joseph, 1907- ♦Le Prdfesseur Georges Morache; sa vie et son oeuvre. 24p. portr. 8? Strasb. [n. pub. 1933. HINSCHE, Georg, 1888- ♦Beitrage zur vergleichenden Sexualphysiologie. I: Ueber Brunst- und Kopulationsreaktionen des Bufo vulgaris, p.564-606. 8? [Lpz., Breitkopf & Hartel] 1928. Also Zschr. vergleich. Physiol, 1926, 4: HINSCHE, Walter, 1902- ♦Die Friih- diagnose der Kieferaktinomykose [Berlin] 35p. 23cm. Charlottenb., Gebr. Hoffmann, 1936. HINSDALE, Albert Euclid, 1881-1924. Writings (The) of Albert E. Hinsdale. J. Am. Inst, Homeop 1929, 22: 684; passim. v' HINSDALE, Wilbert B., 1851- , A GREENMAN, Emerson F. Perforated Indian crania in Michigan. 3 p. 1. Kip. illust. 4 pl. 23cm. Ann Arb., Mich., Univ. Michigan press 1936. Forms No. 5, Occas. Contr. Univ. Michigan Mus. Anthrop HINSELMANN, H[ans] 1884- Die Aetio- logie, Symptomatologie und Diagnostik des Uteruscarcinoms. p.854-953. 8? BerL, 1930. In Handb. Gyn. (J. Veit & W. Stockel) 3. Aufl, Berl, 1930 6. Bd, 1. Halfte. ---- Die Aetiologie, Symptomatologie und Diagnostik des Chorionepithelioms. p. 1108-35 8? BerL, 1930. In Handb. Gyn. (J. Veit& W. Stockel) 3. Aufl, Berl, 1930 6. Bd, 1. Halfte. —— Einfiihrung in die Kolposkopie. 51p illust. 8? Hamburg, P. Hartung [1933] See also Franque, Otto von, Hinselmann, H, & Meyer, Robert. Anatomie und Diagnostik der Carcinome \&r j 1167p. roy. 8? Munch, 1930. HINSHAW, Wfilliam] R[ussell] 1896- , & SANDERS, E. F. Control of Salmonella pullo- rum infection. 23p. 8? Amherst, Mass., 1928. Forms Control ser. Bull. 43, Massachusetts Agr. Exp. Sta. HINSIE, Leland Earl, 1895- The treat- ment of schizophrenia, xvii, 206p. 8? Bait., Williams & Wilkins co., 1930. —— Syllabus of psychiatry; a guide to general orientation, x, 348p. 8? Utica, N. Y., State Hosp. press, 1933. ---■ Concepts and problems of psycho- therapy, xii, 199p. pl. tab. 8? N. Y., Columbia Univ. press, 1937. ----Visual outline of psychiatry, v, 109p. diagr. 22cm. N. Y., Oxford Univ. press, 1941. ---- & BLALOCK, Joseph R. Electro- pyrexia in general paralysis, iv, 90p. pl. tab. ch. 8? Utica, N. Y., State Hosp. press, 1934. HINSIE, Leland Earl, 1895- , & SHATZ- KY, Jacob. Psychiatric dictionary, with en- cyclopedic treatment of modern terms, vi p. 5 1. 559p. 24cm. Lond., Oxford Univ. press [1940] HINSTORFF, Detloff [Carl Georg Percy] 1902- ♦Grundumsatzuntersuchungen bei Otosklerose. 24p. 8? Frankf. a. M., H. Munch, 1929. HINTENBERGER, Karl, 1907- ♦Bei- trage zur Problematic des zahnarztlichen Gusses. 27p. 8? Bonn, H. Trapp, 1935. HINTERLANG, Hans, 1910- +Beitrag zur Frage des Sauren-Basen-Gleichgewichtes in der Schwangerschaft; das Verhalten der Alkali- reserve in der Schwangerschaft. 23p. 8° Giessen, W. Herr, 1937. HINTON, C. H. Scientific romances. Ser. 1-2. 229p.; 177p. 12? Lond., G. Allen & Unwin [1922-25] HINTON, James, 1822-75. Hopkins, E. Life and letters of James Hinton; with an introduction by Sir W. W. Gull. 8. ed. 371p. 12! Lond, 1906. HINTON, James William, 1894- See Erdmann, John Frederick, & Hinton, J. W. Erdmann's clinics; excerpts from the clinics of John F. Erdmann. 315p. 8? Phila, 1932. HINTON, Martin Alister Campbell, 1883- Rats and mice as enemies of mankind, x, 63p. 6 illust. 2 pl. 8? Lond. [W. Clowes & sons] 1918. HINTON, W. H. Ethel Ambrose; pioneer medical missionary, Poona and Indian Village Mission, Bombay Presidency, India. 255p. pl. portr. 8? Lond., Marshall, Morgan & Scott [1936] HINTON 655 HINZPETER HINTON, William Augustus, 1883- Syphilis and its treatment. xvi, 321p. 8? N. Y., Macmillan co., 1936. HINTZ, Wolfgang, 1912- ♦Die Pneu- mothoraxtherapie im Greisenalter. 15p. 22cm. Rostock, G. Neumann, 1937. HINTZE, Charlotte, 1905- ♦Das Menin- giom der Olfaktoriusgrube [Berlin] 47p. 8? Jena, G. Neuenhahn, 1932. HINTZE, Gerhard, 1910- ♦Ueber ange- borene Veranderungen der Mundspalte mit besonderer Berucksichtigung einer eigenen Beob- achtung von Makrostomie. 22p. 8? Miinch., Bayer. Dr., 1934. HINTZE, Hans, 1899- ♦Die Behandlung der tuberkulosen Peritonitis und ihre Resultate (Auszug) lip. 8? Bonn, R. Stodieck, 1925. HINTZE, Heinz Eberhard, 1909- ♦Ueber tiefhegende Lipome [Freiburg] 14p. 8? En- dingen, E. J. Kniebuehler, 1934. HINTZE, Hilda, 1907- ♦Zur operativen Behandlung der muskularen Kieferklemme. 19p. 8? Konigsb. i. Pr., J. Raabe, 1930. HINTZE, Kurt, 1866- Sexual- und Fortpflanzungshygiene. 4 p. 1. 131p. 8? Lpz., Kabitzsch, 1925. HINTZE, Otto, 1902- +Zur Klinik der Puerperalpsychosen [Kiel] 27p. 2 1. 8? Erfurt, A. Stenger, 1926. HINTZE, Rudolf, 1907- ♦Beitrage zur Geschichte der Zahnbtirste und anderer Mittel zur Mund- und Zahnpflege. 61p. 8? [BerL, Meissner & Wermke] 1930. HINTZE, Wilhelm [Karl Anton] 1902- ♦Die Therapie der Bronchiektasien. 50p. 8? Bonn, P. Kubens, 1928. HINTZE, Wolfgang [Konrad Walter] 1910- ♦Die Osteomyelitis der Wirbelsaule (erortert an 3 zur Beobachtung gelangten Erkrankungsfallen) 36p. 8? BerL, K. & R. Hoffmann [1938] HINTZMANN, Konrad, 1901- ♦Ueber Anasthesierungsmethoden der nasalen Neben- hohlen mit besonderer Berucksichtigung des Oberkiefers. 19p. 5 pl. 8? Konigsb., J. Raabe, 1925. HINTZMANN, Walther, 1902- ♦Ueber das Haemotoxin des Bacillus jordaniformis. 28p. 8? Frankf. a. M., H. Miinch, 1933. HINUEBER, Susanna von, 1907- ♦Be- stimmung der Ventilationsgrosse in bewohnten Raumen. 15p. 8? Tiib., E. Gobel, 1933. HINZ, Ernst, 1900- ♦Zur Prophylaxe der Uebertragung ansteckender Krankheiten durch das Friseurgewerbe mit experimentellen Beitrag zur Frage der Rasierpinsel-Desinfektion. 32p. 8? Lpz., A. Edelmann, 1935. HINZ, Hans Dieter, 1909- ^Zur klini- schen Bedeutung der Sakralisation und Lumbali- sation des 5. Lendenwirbels [Berlin] 31 p. pl. 8? Essen, Fredebeul & Koenen, 1934. HINZ, Hans [Max Karl] 1907- ♦Ueber das N-Methyl-2-benzthiazolon-methid und das gewohnlich als Fischer'sche Base bezeichnet N, 3, 3-Trimethyl-2-indolinon-methid. 35p. 22^ cm. Kiel, Schmidt & Klaunig, 1938. HINZ, Irmgard, 1912- ♦Untersuchungen iiber die Grosse des Erythrocytendurchmessers und iiber die Price-Jones-Kurve im normalen Blut, bei sekundarer Anamie, pernicioser Anamie, myeloischer Leukamie und nach Splenektomie [Berlin] 24p. 8? Charlottenb., K. & R. Hoffmann, 1938. HINZ, Wilhelm [Hans Friedrich] 1891- See Regenbogen, Otto, & Hinz, W. Grundriss der Arz- neiverordnungslehre [&c] 211p. 8? Berl, 1924. HINZPETER, Hermann, 1907- ♦Ueber die Prognose der Rezidivhernie. 15p. 23^cm Kiel, Schmidt & Klaunig, 1934. HIP. See also Hip-bone; Hip-joint; Pelvis; Thigh. Henneberg, B. Archaologisch-anatomisches. Zschr. Anat Entw, 1939-40, 110: 385-8.-Howell, A. B. Morphogenesis Mthe architecture of hip and thigh. J. Morph, 1938, 62: ---- Amputation. See Hip-joint, Surgery. ---- Bursae [including diseases] Ehrlich. Ein seltener Fall von Schleimbeutelentzundung an der Hufte. Fortsch. Rontgenstrahl, 1928, 37: 847-51.— Gerard, M. Calcification de la bourse du grand fessier. Rev med. est, 1932, 60: 786.—Lecocq, E. Peritrochanteric bursitis- report of acase. J. Bone Surg, 1931, 13: 872.—Sandstrom, C [Peritendinitis calcarea of the hip-joint] Sven. lak. sail, forh, 1931, 37-47.—Schein, A. J, & Lehmann, O. Acute trochanteric bursitis with calcification. Surgery, 1941, 9: 771-9. ---- Coxalgia. Cagny, R. M. F. de. ♦Contribution a l'etude de la boiterie, sequelle des coxalgies. 122p. 8° Par., 1937. _ Faure, N. ♦Contribution a l'etude du diagnostic des coxalgies aigues. 75p. 24cm. Toulouse, 1933. Richard, A. Coxalgie. p.3397-480. 8° Par., 1937. In Traite chir. orthop. (Ombredanne) Par, 1937, 4: Sorrel, E., Sorrel, Y. D., & Delahaye, A. La coxalgie. 41p. 8? Par., 1931. Allard, L. La coxalgie double. Rev. orthop. Par, 1937 3. ser, 24: 449-78.—Calve, J, Galland, M, & Cagny, R. de. Pathogenesis of the limp due to coxalgia. J. Bone Surg, 1939, 21: 12-25.—Carli, C. Coxalgia transitoria. Arch. ital. chir, 1935, 41: 1002.—Cavelin, C. La coxalgie de l'adulte. Progr. med. Par, 1928, 43: 1069; 1149.—Colonna, P. C. The differ- ential diagnosis of the painful hip in childhood. Am. J. Surg, 1941, 54: 609-13.—Cuneo. Le diagnostic differentiel de la coxalgie k la periode de d6but. Rev. gin. clin. thdr, 1935, 49: 372-4.—Flournoy, H. Organicit6 dynamique; k propos d'un cas de coxalgie hysterique. Rev. med. Suisse rom, 1939, 59: 287-305.—Froelich. Coxalgie double. Rev. orthop. Par, 1937, 3. ser, 24: 638-44.—Fugueroa. Coxalgia y nefrosis lipoidea. Med. ibera, 1934, 28: 145.—Galland, M. A propos du grand raccourcissement, sequelle de la coxalgie. Bull. Soc. chir. Paris, 1932, 24: 175-7.—Gilmour, J. Some causes of pain in the hip in childhood and in adolescence. Newcastle M. J, 1927-28, 8: 82-96.—Glasner, J. O sinal de Calot na coxalgia. Arq. brasil. cir, 1940, 8: 95-8. Also Impr. med, Rio, 1941, 17: 59.—Guerin, R. Arthrodese dans le traite- ment de la coxalgie en Evolution chez l'adulte. J. mid. Bor- deaux, 1937, 114: 849-60.—Laffont. Bassin de coxalgie double. chez une femme de 40 ans, ayant toujours march£ k quattre pattes. Bull. Soc. obst. gyn. Paris, 1933, 22: 478-82.—Marti, T. Acrostealgie. Rev. orthop. Par, 1938, 3. ser, 25: 651.— Massart, R, & Vidal-Naquet, G. La coxalgie. In their Prat. orthop. Par, 1938, 467-508.—Mathieu, P. Les sequelles de la coxalgie. Medecine, Par, 1926, 8: 24.—Mauclaire. Hanche douloureuse avec os acetabulum superieur. Bull. Soc. nat. chir. Par, 1928, 54: 1394-9—Murioz, J. J. Secuelas y complicaciones de la coxalgia. Arch, espan. pediat, 1932, 16: 337.—Richard, A, & Graffin, P. Diagnostic de la coxalgie k forme hypertrophique au debut. Gaz. hop, 1933, 106: 309- 11.—Rocher, H. L. A propos de la coxalgie cotyloidienne, 7 observations. Bordeaux chir, 1931, 2: 101-18.—Scholz, B. Fehldiagnosen bei Hiiftschmerz. Deut. med. Wschr, 1935, 61: 53; 96. Also In Samml. wicht. Fruhdiagn, Lpz, 1936, 20-33.—Wakeley, C. P. G. Case of coxalgia, for diagnosis. Proc. R. Soc. M, Lond, 1928-29, 22: Sect. CUn, 47.—Weve, H. [Case of chronic coxalgia] Ned. tschr. geneesk, 1929, 73: pt 2, 4104-10. ---- Coxalgia: Treatment. Bufnoih, P. ♦Les arthrodeses de la hanche dans les coxalgies. 109p. 8? Par., 1933. Hollander, A. ♦Contribution a l'etude des operations mutilantes dans la coxalgie fistulisee grave; expose d'une technique nouvelle. 89p. 8? Par., 1927. Karabarbounis, L. A. ♦L'arthrodese pour coxalgie en evolution chez l'enfant. 79p. 8? Par., 1934. HIP 656 HIP Mougexot, J. *L'arthrodese extra-articulairc de la hanche chez l'enfant dans la coxalgie (a la periode d'etat et en fin devolution) .[Lyon] 62p. 8? Bourg, 1936. Audet, G. Coxalgie gu6rie en attitude vicieuse; genu valgum rompensateur; correction orthopfidique. BuU. med. Quebec, 1927. 28: 133. 2 pl.—Bastos y Ansart, M. Sobre el trata- miento de la coxalgia por el bloqueo mediante injertos 6seos. Prensa med. argent, 1930-31, 17: 1263^76 —Berard, F. Sur la valeur respective des diff6rentes voies d'abord de l'articu- lation de la hanche pour les operations ankylosantes dans la roxalgie. Rev. chir. Par, 1930, 68: 207-23. 7 pl.- Bristow, W. R. Result- of operations on painful hips. Tr. Am. Surg. Ass.. 1934. 52: U',9-80. Also Ann. Surg, 1934, 100: 1043-54 — Calot. Du traitement de la coxalgie. P. verb. Congr. fr. chir, 1931, 40: 423-7. Also Monde med, 1932, 42: 1-8— Calve. J. Indications de la fixation de la hanche dans la coxalgie; greffon intertemoro-ischiatique; voie d'aceds par osteotomie et section diaphysaire sus-trochanteriennes temporaires. Rapp. Congr. Soc. internat. chir, 1929 30, 8. Congr, 2: 350-3 — Chutro, P. Sobre artrodesis extra-articular en la coxalgia. Bob Soc. cir. B. Aires, 1930, 14: 442-8.—Clavelin. C. Arthro- dese intra- et extra-articulaire chez un ancien coxalgique. Bull. Soc. nat. chir. Par, 1928, 54: 770-3.—Delahayes. Resultat d'arthrodese de la hanche pour coxalgie ancienne. Rev. orthop. Par, 1929, 3. ser, 16: 632. ------ Technique de l'arthrodese extra-articulaire de la hanche pour coxalgie chez l'enfant de moins de 12 ans. Bordeaux chir, 1933, 4: 393. Also J. med. Bordeaux, 1933, 110: 48.—Delahaye, A, & Courvoisier, J. N. Indications et limites de l'arthrodese de hanche dans le traitement des coxalgies de l'enfant et de l'adulte. Presse med, 1933, 41: 757-61.—Fernandez, I. Artiodesis en la coxalgia infantil. Arch, med, Madr, 1934, 37: 129.------ Procedimientos quirurgicos modernos en el tratamiento de la coxalgia. Med. ibera, 1934, 28: 462. ------ Artrodesis en la coxalgia infantil. Siglo mid., 1934, 93: 143.—Froelieh. Traitement ambulatoire de la coxalgie. P. verb. Congr. fr. chir, 1931, 40: 405-8.—Fruchaud, H, & Audureau, J. Arthro- dese extra-articulaire de la hanche pour coxalgie grave en Evolution chez une adulte. Bull. Soc. nat. chir. Par, 1930, 56: 176-82.—Gama, C. da. Da fixacao na coxalgia. Pub. mid., S. Paulo, 1941, 13: No. 5, 13-30.—Ghormley, R. K, & Coventry, M. B. Surgical treatment of painful hips of adults. J. Bone Surg., 1942 24: 424-8. Also Surgery, 1942, 11: 840 (Abstr.)—Gonzalez Aguilar, J. La artrodesis extraarticular de la cadera en la coxalgia. Rev. cir, B. Air, 1931, 10: 574— 88.—Guilleminct. Arthrodese extra-articulaire pour coxalgie en Evolution chez un enfant. Lyon chir, 1935, 32: 449-52.— Hamant & Chalnot. Resultat d'une arthrodese de la hanche pour coxalgie op6r6e au debut de Involution. Rev. mid. Nancy, 1937, 65: 310-2.—Ianas, A. L'arthrodese de la hanche par verrouillement trochant6ro-iliaque, dans certaines formes de coxalgie; modification de la technique op^ratoire. Rev. chir, Bucur, 1940, 43: 788-96, 4 pl.—Lasserre, C. Coxalgie k 2 temps terminfie par une ankylose osseuse. Bordeaux chir, 1932, 3: 458-60. ------ Rdsultats de 3 arthrodeses de la hanche pour coxalgie. Ibid, 1933, 4: 394. Also J. m6d. Bordeaux, 1933, 110: 49-51.—Lavezzo, P. Una modificaci6n en el procedimiento cldsico del enyesado para los casos de coxalgia. Sem. m6d„ B. Air, 1928, 35: 1390-4.—Le Fort. Les conceptions actuelles du traitement de la coxalgie non fistuleuse. Presse therm, clim, 1935, 75: 37-40. ------ & Minne, J. Les conceptions actuelles du traitement de la coxal- gie non fistuleuse. Echo m6d. nord, 1932, 36: 433.—L'Espis- copo, J. B. Bone block for painful hips. J. Bone Surg, 1938, 20: 901-11.—Leriche. Greffes osseuses intra- et extra-articu- laires, apres ablation des lesions, dans la coxalgie en Evolution chez l'adulte. Lyon chir.. 1928, 25: 558-61.—Massart, R. Arthrodese de la hanche pour coxalgie avec fistulisation persistante. Bordeaux chir, 1932, 3: 440.—Mathieu, P. Traitement des sequelles de la coxalgie (en dehors du rgveil de l'infection tuberculeuse) Rev. orthop. Par, 1926, 13: 3. ser, 581-651. Also Presse mid., 1926, 34: 1301-3. ------ & Wilmoth. L'arthrodese extra-articulaire dans la coxalgie. J. chir. Par, 1926, 28: 130-46.—Michel, G, & Mutel. Arthro- dese de la hanche pour coxalgie ancienne. Bull. Soc. nat. chir. Par, 1929, 55: 31-6.—Nove-Josserand, Berard, F, & Pouzet. Le traitement conservateur dans la coxalgie. J. med. Paris, 1932, 52: 359-62. Also Med. inf., Par, 1932, 39: 65-77.—Ottolenghi, C. E. La artrodesis extraarticular de la cadera en la coxalgia. Rev. ortop. traumat, B. Air, 1931-32, 1: 153-224— Page C. M. The late results of operation for chronic painful hip. Lancet, Lond, 1920, 1: 1087-90. ------ Elmslie, R. C. [et al.] Discussion on the late results of operation for chronic painful hip. Proc. R. Soc. M, Lond, 1925-26 19: Sect. Orthop, 39-49.—Paoli, J. Le traitement de la coxalgie par les arthrodeses. Marseille med, 1930, 67: 357- 60.—Papin, E. L'osteotomie d'appui dans la coxalgie. Bor- deaux chir, 1931,2: 362.—Pasman, R. E. Artrodesis extra- articular de la cadera en la coxalgia. Bol. Soc. cir. B. Aires 1929, 13: 123-43.—Patel, M, & Berard. F. Arthrodese de hanche pour coxalgie en evolution, chez l'adulte. In Livre jub. (Hartmann. H.) Par, 1932, 529-37.—Paulino Filho, A. Artrodese extra-articular na coxalgia em evolucao. Arch Inst. Benjamin Baptista, Rio, 1936, 2: 49-S3, pl. Also \cta med, RLo, 1939, 3: 39-60— Richard, A, & Clavelin, C. Sept observations d'arthrodeses de la hanche pour coxalgie. Bull Soc. nat. chir., Par., 1930, 56: 1422-34.—Richard, A, & Colmenares, J. Technique de l'arthrodese pour coxalgie chea l'enfant. Rev. orthop. Par, 1938, 3. sir., 25: 701-7.—Richard, A, & Elbim, A. Indications it techniques dc l'arthrodese pom coxalgie. J. chir. Par, 1931, 39: 1-40.—Rivarola & Land mir, A. F. A proposito de artrodesis extra-articular de la caderu en la coxalgia. Bol. Soc. cir. B. Aires, 1929, 13: 152-4.— Rocher, H. I, Technique simplifiee pour failhroddso extra- articulaire de la hanche par groffon tibial dans la coxalgie type 37. J. med. Bordeaux, 1937, 114: pl 2, 09-71.--- Arthrodese extra-articulaire de la hanche pour coxalgie; appareil pelvi-crural en duralumin. Ibid, 272-5.---- ' Osteolyse post-traumatique du col du femur sur une ankylose par coxalgie. Arch. ital. chir, 1938, 54: 263-73. —"---. Rdsultat fonctionnel parfait dans une arthrodese extra-articu- laire de la hanche par coxalgie. Presse med, 1940, 48: 502.— Rocher, L. Intorno al trattamento chirurgico della coxalgia nell'infanzia ed al prineipio della sua evoluzione. Arch. ital. chir, 1933, 35: 803. Roller . Tavernier. L. Arthrodese de la hanche au debut de revolution d'une coxalgie grave. Lyon chir, 1932, 29: 727-9. — L'arthrodese dans les coxalgies en evolution chez les grands enfants. Ibid, 1936. 33: 733-8.—Vasconcelos. M. de. As artrodeses na coxalgia. Med. contemp, Lisb, 1930. 54: 41; 57.—Vial & Peyret. Reflexions sur l'arthrodese articulaire de la hanche dans la coxalgie en evolution chez l'adulte. Rev med. Nancy, 1939, 67: 6-10.—Vilardell, J. M. Estudio actual del tratamiento de la coxalgia. Med. ibera, 1935, 29: pt 2, 70.—Votta, E. A. Coxalgia; tratamiento quirurgico por el procedimiento Robertson Lavalle. Sem. med, B. Air, 1930, 37: pt 2, 1487-512. ---- Coxalgia; su tratamiento. Ibid, 1937, 44: 1382 8.—Wilmoth, d'AIIaines & Delahaye. Arthro- dese extra-articulaire de la hanche pour coxalgie en evolution; coxalgie; arthrodese extra-articulaire; presentation de pieces anatomiques d'arthrodese de hanche pour coxalgie ancienne. Bull. Soc. nat. chir. Par, 1930, 56: 153-73—Yovtchitch. D. M. Arthrodese extra articulaire dans un cas dc coxalgie avec pseudarthrose intracotyloi'dienrie solide; ankylose osseuse. Ibid, 1928, 54: 984-0.—Zeno, L. Artrodesis extraarticular en la coxalgia; fundamentos tecnicos. Rev. ortop. traumat, B. Air, 1934-35, 4: 166-74. ---- Cyst. Lebrun. Kyste solitaire de l'extremite sup6rieure du f6mur; intervention; r6sultat eloigne. Bull. Soc. na1. chir. Par, 1927, 53: 753-5.—Patel. Kyste-de l'extremite superieure du f6mur; evidement et greffe tibiale. Lyon chir, 1933, 30: 327-30. ---- Disease. Albee, F. EL, & Preston, R. L. Injuries and diseases of the hip; surgery and conservative treatment. 298p. 8? N. Y., 1937. Menzen, G. *EigentumlicheHufterkrankung. 19p. 8? Wiirzb., 1936. Benjamin, B, & Miller, P. R. Hypothyroidism as a cause of disease of the hip. Am. J. Dis. Child, 1938, 55: 1189-211.— Calot, F. Les notions indispensables k tous sur la renovation de la pathologie de la hanche par les derniers travaux. Monde med, 1926, 36: 1-13.------ Ce que tout praticien doit savoir de la renovation des diagnostics des maladies de la hanche par les travaux d'apres-guerre. Ibid, 1929, 39: 65-76. ------ Sur le diagnostic des maladies de la hanche d'aprea les derniers travaux. Vie med, 1929, 5: 1003-5. ----- Ueber neuere Anschauungen in der Pathologie der Hiifte auf Grund der Arbeiten der letzten Jahre. Zschr. orthop. Chir, 1929, 51: 134—60. ------ Notions indispensables k tous sur la renovation de la pathologie de la hanche par les travaux d'apres-guerre. Rev. gin. clin. ther, 1932, 46: 193-97 — Case (A) of old hip disease. Postgrad. M. J, Lond, 1935, 11: 360.—Charry, R. Estado actual de la cirugia de la cadera en las insuficiencias inveteradas con gran claudicaci6n; resultadoa de nuestra pr&tiea personal. Cir. ortop. traumat, Habana, 1940, 8: 37-49.—Chavannaz, J., & Radoievitch, S. A propos des coxopathies. J. med. Bordeaux, 1925, 55: 731-9.—Dc Lucchi, 6. Sulla patogenesi delle deformity e delle malattie dell'anca dipendenti da displasia congenita. Chir. org. movim, 1939-40, 25: 359-75.—Evans, E. T. The chronically disabled hip. Physiother. Rev, 1939, 19: 330-2.—Forestier. J. Un signe differentiel entre les arthropathies de la hanche et les algies sciatiques; lc signe du roulement k billes dans l'examen de la hanche en decubitus ventral. Rev. neur. Par, 1932, 39: 251-4.—Forrester-Brown, M. The diagnosis of abnormal hip conditions in children. Lancet, Lond, 1935, 1: 1377-81. ------A series illustrating obscure hip-conditions in children. Clin. J, Lond, 1937, 66: 8-14.—Francisco, G. B. Non- tuberculous hips in children simulating tuberculo-ia. J. Missouri M. Ass, 1926, 23: 385-8.—Ghormley, R. K. Lesions of the hip in childhood and adolescence and their relation to lesions of the hip in the adult. Rocky Mountain M. J, 1940, 37: 956-61.—Hartmann. Traitement des abces de la r6gion de la hanche eon-<*cutiiV k la coxalgie. Rev. gin. clin. thfr, 1926, 40: 596.— Key, J. A. Some diagnostic problems in the HIP 657 HIP hip in early life. J. Am. M. Ass, 1927, 88: 82-7.—McLaren, W. W. Mild hip disease. Med. J. Australia, 1937, 1: 767 — Marottoli, O. R. Concepto actual y clasificaci6n de los sin- dromes quiriirgicos de la cadera en la infancia. Dfa m6d, B. Air, 1932-33, 5: 499. Also Arch, pediat. Uruguay, 1933, 4: 5- passim.—Massart, R. Les infirmes de la hanche, leur traitement chirurgical. Bull. Soc. med. Palis, 1931, 132-9. Also Rev. med. fr, 1931, 12: 665-72.—Peabody, C. W. The gait in hip limp. Physiother. Rev, 1935, 15: 48-50.—Potter, R P Roentgenological findings in non-tuberculous lesions of the hip. Wisconsin M. J, 1933, 32: 19-21.—Robert. P, Lelong, J, & Merklen, R. Un diagnostic rare d'affection de la hanche. Bull. Soc. radiol. med. France, 1933, 21: 290.— Scarenzio, A. De la douleur au genou sympathique des maladies de la hanche. Presse med. beige, 1861, 13: 61-3.— Sisto Hontan, F. Diagnostico de las afecciones de la cadera en el niflo. Pediat. espan, 1926, 15: 317-31.—Sneed. W. L. Acute infections of the hip. Surg. Clin. N. America, 1931, 11: 057-66.—Taylor, G. H. Suppurative hip in children. J. M. Soc. N. Jersey, 1934, 31: 458-60.—Taylor, H. Diagnosis of hip disabilities in children. Ibid, 1937, 34: 11- 4.—Trethowan, W H. Disorders of the hip, and other conditions. Guy's Hosp. Rep, Lond, 1937, 87: 229-53. ---- Epiphyseolysis. See Hip-joint, Coxa vara, epiphyseal. .--- Epiphysitis. Canelli, A. F. Sulla questione delle epifisiti in pediatria. Pediatria (Riv.) 1927, 35: 703-9.—Dreyfus, .1. R. Die Epi- physitis acetabuli im Kindesalter. Zbl. Chir, 1937, 64: 1162.—Lance. L'epiphysite intracotyloidienne de croissance de la hanche. Gaz. med. France, 1932, 346.—Lipscomb, E. J. Bilateral acute epiphysitis of the hips; case report. Memphis M. J, 1935, 10: No. 10. 39.—Miller, O. L. Acute transient epiphysitis of the hip joint. J. Am. M. Ass, 1931, 96: 575-9.— Narasimhan, N. S. Acute epiphysitis of the hip joint. Madras M. J, 1931, 13: 180-4, pl.—Poli, A. Epifisite dell'anca da Bacterium coli. Arch, ortop, Milano, 1927, 43: 386-402.— Porro, N. Sugli esiti delle epifisiti dell'anca. Radiol, med, Milano, 1927. 14: 12-20. Also Atti Congr. ital. radiol. med, 1928, 7: 540-2. ---- Examination. See also Hip-joint, Radiography. Ballesteros, G. A. Exploracicn de la cadera. Rev. cienc. med, Mex, 1929, 7: 358-71.—Mathieu, P. Examen de la hanche. In Traite chir. orthop. (Ombi-edanne) Par, 1937, 4: 3026-37.—Perpina, V. S. Unsere Technik bei Huftmessuneen. Beitr. klin. Chir, 1932, 156: 31 — Sanchis Perpina, V. Nuestra tecnica en la mensuracion de la c-adera. Progr. clin, Madr, 1931, 39: 653-60. ---- Femoral head. See also Femur. Bruno, G, & Ottonello. P. Osservazioni suU'architettura del tessuto spugnoso dell'epifisi prossimale del femore dell'uomo con particolare riguardo al cosl detto triangolo di Ward ed alio sperone femorale. Radiol, med, Milano, 1933, 20: 1201-6 — Gerzanits, P. [Observations on the structure of the head of the femur by means of a new method of investigation] Magy. orv. arch, 1940, 41: 74-9, pl. ---- Femoral head: Abnormity. Rietkotter, A. [W.] *Uf:ber die Deformitaten des Oberschenkelkopfes [Berlin] 22p. 8? Quakenbruck, 1936. Brownlee, A. Congenital absence of head of femur. Brit. M. J, 1932, 2: 835.—Loeffler, F. Ein seltener Rontgenbe- fund an kindlichen Oberschenkelkopfepiphysen. Zbl. Chir, 1925, 52: 961-3.—Peabody, C. W. Bilateral defect of femoral heads. J. Bone Surg, 1927, 9: 288-93.—Scaduto, G. Man- canza congenita della testa e del collo del femore. Arch. radiol. Nap, 1925, 1: 11-4.—Tucker, W. E. A family with congenital absence of the heads of the femora. Proc. R. Soc. M, Lond, 1934, 27: Sect. Orthop, 573. ---- Femoral head: Disease, and tumor. See also subheadings Osteochondritis de- formans; Osteochondritis dissecans. Arel, F. Spontannekrose des Schenkelkopfes bei Jugend- lichen. Zbl. Chir, 1936, 63: 617-9. ------ Erwiderung zur Spontannekrose des Schenkelkopfes bei Jugendlichen. Ibid, 2134.—Bozsan, E. J. Compression of cancellous bone; principal manifestations in the head and neck of the femur; treatment by connecting drill channels. Am. J. Surg, 1941, 53: 541-618 — Chandler, F. A. Aseptic necrosis of the head of the femur. Wisconsin M. J, 1936, 35: 609-18—Esteve & Martre. Ln cas d'osteolvse essentielle de la tete femorale. Gaz. med. France, 1938, 45: radiol, 485-7.—Floyd, E, & Pittman. J. L. Trans- migration of the head of the femur into the urinary bladder; report of a case. Urol. Cut. Rev, 19-11, 45: 303.—Freund, E. Bilateral aseptic necrosis of the femoral head; problems arising 227475—vol. 7, 4th series----42 in a compensation case. Ann. Surg, 1936, 104: 100-6, 4 pl.__ Hanson, R. Epiphysial necrosis of the caput femoris Acta orthop. scand, 1939, 10: 331-7.—Hilgenreiner, H Zur Spontannekrose des Schenkelkopfes bei Jugendlichen Zbl Chir, 1936, 63: 1266-9.—Hohmann. G. Zur Arbeit von AreP bpontannekrose des Schenkelkopfes bei Jugendlichen. Ibid, 1269-71.—Howell. Metastatic carcinoma, head of femur' following injury chiefly to knee. Bull. Moses Taylor Hosp ' 1933, 2: 52-5.—Kienbock, R, & Selka, A. Ueber Huftgelenks- affektionen mit aseptischer Schenkelkopf-Nekrose. Rontgen- praxis, 1931, 3: 541-4.—Kreuz, L. Ungewohnliclie Verande- rungen an den Huftkopfepiphysen einer Jugendlichen. Fortsch Rontgenstrahl, 1929. 40: 1034-41.—Laarmann. Trau- matische Schenkelkopfnekrosen. Arch, orthop. UnfaUchir 1939-40, 40: 219-21.—Mau, C. Fruhbehandlung der begin- nenden Epiphyscnwa.nderung am Oberschenkelkopf im Adoles- zentenalter. Deut. Zschr. Chir, 1936-37, 248: 214-23.— Phemister, D. B. Fractures of neck of femur, dislocations of hip, and obscure vascular disturbances producing aseptic necrosis of head of femur. Surg. Gyn. Obst, 1934, 59: 415- 40.------Aseptic necrosis of the head of the femur produced by fractures, dislocations and vascular disturbances. Proc. Interst. Postgrad. M. Ass. N. America, 1935, 140-2.—Picot & Cosnier. Osteolyse de )a tete du femur. Bull. Soc. eiectro- radiol. med. France, 1939, 27: 188-90.—Rieder, W. Kurze Vorstellung einer posttraumatisehen Cystenbildung im Oberschenkelkopf. Zbl. Chir, 1934, 61: 2551-4.—Steden, E. Traumatische Zyste des Schenkelkopfes, ein Beitrag zur Frage der Bedeutung des Lig. teres fur die Ernahrung des Schenkel- kopfes. Miinch. med. Wschr, 1925, 72: 517.—Steinsleger, M, e las fracturas del cuello del femur. Rev. cienc. med , Habana, 103S. 1: 179-85.— Schuberth, O. |Fraetura colli femorisl Noid. med, 1930. 1: 237-42—Tinker, M. B, & Tinker, M. 1!.. jr. Fracture of the neck of the femur. J. Am. M. Ass, 1939, 112: 791-6.—Tippett, G. O. Fractured femoral neck. Lancet, Lond, 1941, 2: 812.—Topa. P. Les fractures du col femoral. Rev. chir, Bucur, 1938, 41: 795-829.— Vickors, W, & Little, N. Fractures of the neck of the femur. Med. J. Australia, 1938. 2: so5-8, pl.—Vovchenko, G. V. [Complete, closed fractures of the collum femoris] Ortop. travmat., 1035, 9: 43-7.—Wui«4>erg. M. A. [Fractures of the neck of the femur] Ibid.. 10.30. 10: 57-76.—Warren. F. S. Fracture of the neck "f the femur. Minnesota M, 1939, 22: 523-5/—Watson-Jones, R. Fi-e.-t uios of the neck of the femur. Brit. J. Sum.. 1935-30. 23: 787-808.—Zeno, L. Fractura del cuello del femur. Dia med, B. Air, 1934-35, 7: 316-8. ---- Femoral neck: Fracture, bilateral. Androp, S. Bilateral fracture of the femoral necks caused by metrazol-induced convulsions. J. Nerv. Ment. Dis, 1941, 93: 701-4.—Hoffheinz, S. Genagelte doppelseitige Schenkel- halsfraktur. Zbl. Chir, 1037, 64: 2876. ---- Femoral neck: Fracture: Clinical aspects. Apfelbach. G. L. Fractures of the neck of the femur; the biggest subject in the last 2 years before traumatic surgeons. Indust. M, 1935, 4: 187-9.—Barba Inclan, A. Fracturas lieiiijimis del cuello femoral. Cir. ortop. traumat, Habana, lP4(i. 8: 52-0—Chance, A. Clinical interpretation of fractures of the neck of the femur. Irish J. M. Sc, 1933, ser. 6, 212-4.— Crowe, H. E. A common error in surgical judgment. California We-i. M.. 1932, 37: 250.—Dufour, A. Probiemes poses par une fracture du col du femur. Hdpital, 1937, 25: 609-12.— Geckeler, E. O. The problem of the unsolved fracture. Hahne- man. Month, 1936, 71: 905-14.—Marino-Zuco, C. Alcuni casi di frattura del collo del femore di trattamento partico- larmente difficile. Boll. Accad. med. Roma, 1938, 64: 208.— Moorhead. J. J. Fracture of the neck of the femur: the prob- lem fracture. Proc. Interst. Postgrad. M. Ass. N. America 1936, 340-5. ---- Femoral neck: Fracture: Complication. Matthias, E. *Ueber aseptische Epiphy- sennekrose nach lateraler Schenkelhalsfraktur bei Jugendlichen. 27p. 8? Konigsb., 1935. Pascal, R. *Modifications morphologiques de la tete du ft'mur apres synthese pour fracture du col. 79p. 8? Par., 1930. Basset, A. Resorption partielle tardive de la tote du femur apres vissage sans arthrotomie pour fracture transeervicale du col. Rev. orthop. Par, 1932, 3. ser, 19: 5N0 COS. Herirmunn, E. Spat-uhaden nach geheilten Schcnki 4hal.shritch.cn. Deut Zschr. Chir, 1935, 245: 496-503.—Carrell. B, .t Carrell, \V. R Fractures in the neck of the femur in children with particular reference to aseptic necrosis. J. Bone Sure, 1941, 23: 225- 30.—('harrier, M, Rocher, C, & Goorgot. ('as de luxation do la hanche survenu au cours du traitement dune fracture du femur par enclouage. Bordeaux chir, 1037. 8: 22 5.—Clark, W. A. Nouveau cas de coxarthrie tardive api-Os fracture du col du femur. Bull. Soc. nat. chir. Par, 1933, 59: 1052-4.— Euren, R. Ein Fall von Epiphysennekrose bei geheilter Collumfraktur. Acta chir. scand, 1931-32, 69: 8-20, 2 pl— Felsenreich, F. Histologische Lfntersiichungen an opcricrten Scbenkelhalsbruchen. Audi. klin. Chir, 1938, 192: 490- 1938-39, 194: 96; 584—Inclan. A. Secuelas dcrivadas dei trastorno de consolidaciOn de las fracturas del cuello del femur. Cir. ortop. traumat, Habana, 1940, 8: 148 68.— Johansson, S. Ueber Epiphysennekrose bei geheilten Collum- frakturen. Zbl. Chir, 1927, 54: 2214-22— Mazzabella. (). I danni delle fratture suH'irrorazione sanguigna del collo e della testa femorali. Policlinico, 1037, 44: sez. prat, 101-4.— Morville [Spontaneous subtrochanteric fracture following boring of the neck of the femur] Nord. med, 1939, 3: 2140.— Naeraa, A. On secondary epiphyseal necrosis after collum femoris fracture in voung persons. Acta chir. scand, 1937-38, 80: 238-50, 6 pl- Relti),'. W. Ueber den todlicb.cn Ausgang eines Schenkelhalsbmches. Zbl. Chir, 1933, 60: 2123-6.— Robineau & Busser. Sur un trouble particulier observe aprSa vissage et consolidation dune fracture du col du femur. Ann. anat. path. Par, 1939. 16: 644-52.—Rochet, P.. Corajod & Frieh. D6chirure de l'artere femorale profonde par osteophyte issu du cal d'une fracture basicervicale du femur. Lyon chir, 1937, 34: 80-9.—Rouhier. G„ & Lecoeur, P. Osteoarthro- pathies k distance chez certains fractures du col femoral. Bull. Soc. nat. chir. Par, 1932, 58: 1029-38.—Santos, J. V. Changes in the head of the femur after complete intracapsular fracture of the neck. Arch. Surg, 1930, 21: 470-530. Also repr.—Sedillot, J. Coxarthrie? ou sequelle de fracture du col? Bull. Soc. med. Paris, 1937, 100-2.—Strauss. K. Osteomyelitis als Spatfolge nach Vcrschraubung einer Schenkelhalsfraktur. Chirurg, 1939, 11: 793-0.—Sudeck, P. Schenkelhalsfissur mit sekundiirer Dystrophic und Arthrosis deformans. Mschr. Unfallh, 1937. 44: 249-56. ---- Femoral neck: Fracture: Diagnosis. Eckert, F. *Die Auswartsdrehung des Beines bei Schenkelhalsfraktur [Wurzburg] 15p. 8? Munster, 1927. Aalkjacr, V. [Unrecognized fractures of the neck of the femur] Ugeskr. laeger, 1935, 97: 321-7.—Aperlo, G. Per ricordarc il sintomo del Gherini. Chir. org. movim, 1934, 20: 225.—Ceconi, M. La semeiotica delle fratture del collo del femore. Boll. Poliamb. Giuseppe Ronzoni, 1937, 11: 159-200.— Freund, E. Sul quadro radiografico della necrosi asettica nella frattura del collo femorale. Chir. org. movim, 1931-32, 16: 223-44.—Garland, L. H., & Hill, H. A. Fractures of the neck of the femur. Radiology, 1939, 33: 421-38.—Hachner, A. Ueber Schenkelhalsbriiche, insbesondere ubersehene Briiche. Mschr. Unfallh, 1933. 40: 229-37— Kovalevich, M. D. [Diag- nosis of dislocation of the thigh and fracture of the neck of the temur] Vest, khir, 1039, 58: 176-9.—Kunz, H. Seitliche Rontgenaufnahmen bei Oberschenkelhalsbruchen. Zbl. Chir, 1932, 59: 2104.— Lohr. Vorgetauschter Schenkelhalsbruch. Rontgenpraxis, 1935, 7: 400.—Paschetta, V. La methode dea radiographics en 3 positions dans les fractures du col du femur. Arch, electr. m6d, 1930, 38: 12-7.—Philips. H. B. New roentgenographs demonstration of fractured neck of the femur. Am. J. Surg, 1928, n. ser, 5: 392.—Rossi. R. Per la diagnosi della frattura del collo del femore. CUn. chir, Milano, 1926, 29: 641-51.—Shkurov. B. I. [Symptomatology and diagnosis of fractures of the neck of the femur] Ortop. travmat, 1939, 13: 3-8. ---- Femoral neck: Fracture: Healing. Heffels, H. *Uebcr die Einwirkung der anatomischen Verhaltnisse auf die Entstehung und Heilung der Schenkelhalsfrakturen. 32p. 21cm. Bonn, 1937. Lapipe, M. *Contribution a 1'dtude du pronostic radiographique des fractures du col du femur. 88p. 8? Par., 1938. Anschiitz. Demonstration eines Praparates einer im Abduk- tionsgipsverband ideal geheilten medialen Schenkelhalsfraktur. Munch, med. Wschr, 1928. 75: 110.—Felsenreich, F. Histo- logische Untersuchungen an operierten Schenkelhalsbrtichen; grosse Einbriiche der Kopfoberflache, Sequestration, Geroll- cysten und verwandte Zustandbilder sowie Ausheilungsvorgange HIP 659 HIP nach solchen Destruktionsprozessen. Arch. klin. Chir, 1939, 195- 413-54.—G6mez Duran, M. Nota clinica sobre consoh- daci6n esponWLnea de fractura del cuello y trocanter del femur en un adolescente. Siglo med, 1932, 89: 213.-Kleinborg, S Fracture of the neck of the femur; report of a case with rapid union following e.arlv weight-bearing. J. Bone Surg, 1935, 17: 1041-4 —Lindemann, K. Beitrage zur Frage der penostalen Callusbildung bei Schenkelhalsfrakturen unter Mitteilung eines ..nitrlmisch geheilten Falles von medialer Schenkelhalsfraktur. Deut Zschr Chir, 1929. 214: 300-18.—Merle d'Aubigne. R. Dp la consolidation osseuse dans les fractures cervicales vraies du col du f6mur. J. chir. Par, 1936, 48: 630-45.-PauweIs, V. Crundlagen des Heilungsvorganges bei Schenkelhalsbriichen. Verh. Deut. orthop. Ges. G934) 1935, 29: 54-78. ____Femoral neck: Fracture, impacted. Drotjart, A. Contribution a l'etude des fractures par enfonccment de la cavite cotyloidv avec penetration intrapelvienne de la tett femorale. 25p. 8? Par., 1926. Barbarin, P. A propos des fractures du col du femur traites par l'impaction. Bull. Soc. chir. Paris, 1934, 26: 211. ._____Treves let al] A propos des fractures intra-capsulaires engrenees du col du femur. Ibid, 1929 21: 127-36.—Bard. Fracture engrenee du col du femur. Loire med, 1930, 44: 14_D —Brodier. Fracture engrenee du col du femur. Bull. Soc chir. Paris, 1929. 21: 251.—Christopher, F. Treatment of impacted fracture of the neck of the femur. Tr. West. Surg. Ass. (1939) 1940, 49: 274-87.—Johnson, H. F. Artificial impaction of fractures in the neck of the femur. Nebraska M. J 1934, 19: 416-9.—Odelberg-Johnson, G. Thirteen cases of impacted medial fractures of the neck of the femur. Acta chir. scand, 1928, 63: 107-20, 4 pl.—Paschetta, V. Diagnostic de l'engre'nement des fractures du col du femur par la. methode des radiooraphies en 3 positions. Bull. Soc. radiol. mid. France, 1929ri7: 319-25. ---- Femoral neck: Fracture, incomplete. Burrows, H. J. Incomplete fracture of femoral neck in a case of infantile coxa vara. Brit. M. J, 1940, 1: 569.—Chris- topher F. Treatment of impacted fracture of the neck of the femur. J. Bone Surg, 1940, 22: 161-7.— Dagneau, P. C, & Roger. J. P. Absence d'impotence fonctionnelle immediate chez un malade atteint de fracture incomplete du col femoral. Bull. Soc. med. bop. Quebec, 1934, 8-10.—Freund, E. Histo- logische Untersuchungen iiber den Heilungsvorgang bei einge- kellten Schenkelhalshruchen. Arch, orthop. UnfaUchir, 1930, 28: 489-520.—Judet, H. Fractures vraies intra-capsulaires du col du femur avec penetration. Bull. Soc. chir. Paris, 1934, 26: 187-94.—Krauss, F. Neue Wege in der Behandlung der inkompletten Schenkelhalsfraktur vom Adduktionstyp. Zbl. Chir, 1936, 63: 2858-00.—Lecoq, J. F, & Lecocq, E. Im- pacted fracture of the neck of the femur; case report. J. Bone Surg, 1935, 17: 212.—Madlener, M. J, & Bremer. H. Unvollstandige Schenkelhalsfrakturen beim Erwachsenen. Arch, orthop. UnfaUchir, 1931, 30: 510-5. ---- Femoral neck: Fracture: Industrial as- pect. Brewster, W. R. Fractures of the neck of the femur. Indust. M, 1939, 8: 239-41.—Eberhard, H. A. Die Bedeutung der Oberschenkelhalsbruehe in der Versicherungsmedizin. Aerztl. Sachverst. Ztg, 1926, 32: 237; 247; 262.—Schramm. G. Schenkelhalsbruch und Landesversicherungsanstalt. Verh. Deut. orthop. Ges. (1932) 1933, 27. Kongr, 93-104.—Zur Verth. Der Schenkelhalsbruch in der Unfallheilkunde. Ibid, 37-48. ---- Femoral neck: Fracture, intracapsular. Albee. F. H. Intracapsular fracture on the neck of the femur. Internat. J. M. & S, 1933, 46: 559-64. Also Bol. Soc. cir. B. Aires, 1936, 20: 519-27— Arce, J, & Introzz.i, A. S. Necrosis isquemica del fragmento proximal en las iracturas intracausulares del cuello del femur. Bol. Inst clin. Qu\r, B. Air, 1933-34, 9: 101-20. ALso Bol. Soc. cir. B. Aires, 1933 17: 578-621. Also Sem. med, B. Air, 1933, 40: pt 2, •577-96.— Bankart, A. S. B. Treatment of intracapsular fractures of the femoral neck. Lancet, Lond, 1942, 1: 249-52—Borghi, M. Esiti immediati e lontani delle fratture del collo femorale, in rapporto al loro trattamento crucnto ed incruento con speciale riguardo alle fratture intracapsulari. Chn. chir, Milano, 1J20, 28: 101-57.—Bowcn, W. W. Internal fixation of intracapsular fracture without incision. J. Iowa M. Soc, 1939, 29: 200-4. Bunnell, S. Intracapsular fracture of the neck of the fonm; its primary operative treatment. California West. M, 10.45, 43: 27-32.—Campbell, W. C. Central or intracapsular frac- tures of the neck of the femur. Proc. California Acad. M, 1931- 32, 53, 14 pl. Also South. M. & S, 1933, 2: 1-23. ---— & Smith, H. Central fractures of the neck of the femur; treat- ment by internal fixation. Southwest. M, 1940, 24: 3bl-d.— Carr, F. Internal fixation of acute intra-capsular fractures ot the femoral neck with a Smith-Petersen nail. New Hochelle Hosp. M. Staff Bull, N. Y, 1938. 1: 23-5.—Conwcll, H. E . & Sheriil. J. D. Internal fixation of fractures (intracapsular) of the neck of the femur; report of 21 cases. South, burgeon, 1937, 6: 194-206.—Dickson, F. D. A survey of the manage- ment of intracapsular fracture of the neck of the femur. J. Missouri M. Ass, 1935, 32: 481-7.—Dickson, J. A. Treat- ment of central or intracapsular fractures of the neck of the femur. Cleveland Clin. Q, 1938, 5: 41-8— Elmsli, R. C. The treatment of intracapsular fracture of the neck of the femur. S. Barth. Hosp. Rep, Lond, 1926, 59: 129-34.—El ward, J. F, & Rudner, N. The healing of intracapsular fractures of the neck of the femur. Med. Ann. District of Columbia, 1940, 9: 205-11.—Eyre-Brook, A. L, & Pridie, K. H. Intracapsular fractures of the neck of the femur; final results of 75 consecutive cases treated by the closed method of pinning. Brit. J. Surg, 1941r42, 29: 115-38.—Fay, J. H. A method of reduction and fixation of intracapsular fractures of the femoral neck. N. England J. M, 1934, 211: 607-1 l.—Geist, E. S. Intracapsular fracture of the neck of the femur; a reply to Dr Roval Whitman of New York. J. Lancet, 1931, 51: 230—Gompere, E. L. The ambulatory treatment of recent fractures of the intra- capsular neck of the femur following threaded wire fixation. J. Internat. Coll. Surgeons, 1940, 3: 401-12— Holcomb, O. W. Treatment of intracapsular fractures of the femur with the Smith-Petersen nail; report of 22 consecutive cases. Minne- sota M, 1941, 24: 650-3.—Iglesias y de la Torre, L. Reporte preliminar de las fracturas del cuello del femur intra-capsular tratadas en la clinica 4 de Septiembre. Rev. san. mil, Habana, 1938, 2: 329-41.—Tntra-capsular fracture of femur treated by Smith-Petersen pin. Guy's Hosp. Gaz, Lond, 1935, 49: 261.—Jones, L. Intracapsular fractures of the neck of the femur; a closed double-screw method for reduction and fixation; preliminary report. Ann. Surg, 1933, 97: 237-46. ------ & Lieberman, B. A, jr. Intracapsular fracture of the neck of the femur; case report and pathological study. J. Bone Surg, 1938, 20: 88-92.—Judet, H. II existe une forme fix6e des fractures intra-capsulaires du col du femur; 5 observations personnelles. Bull. Soc. chir. Paris, 1929, 21: 99-110 — Kaplan, I. W. Guide for internal fixation of intracapsular and intertrochanteric fractures of the femur. Am. J. Surg, 1941, 52: 443-6.—Key, J. A. Insertion of Smith-Petersen nail for intracapsular fractures of neck of femur. Ibid, 1937, 36: 466-71.—King, T. Recent intracapsular fractures of the neck of the femur: a critical consideration of their treatment and a desciption of a new technique. Med. J. Australia, 1934, 1: 5-15. ------ Intracapsular fractures of the neck of the femur. Ibid, 107. ------ The closed operation for intracapsular fracture of the neck of the femur; final results in recent and old cases. Brit. J. Surg, 1938-39 26: 721-48— Kummer, A. Die Behandlung der Fractura colli femoris intracapsularis mittels Autoknochentransplantation. Chirurg, 1938, 10: 117- 22.— Luck. J. V. Intracapsular fractures of the neck of the femur; a simple method for properly placing the bone graft. J. Bone Surg, 1935, 17: 332-7.—McKenna, H. Fractures of the neck of the femur with special reference to the treatment of intracapsular fracture. Tr. Am. Surg. Ass, 1930, 48: 423-37. Also Ann. Surg, 1930, 92: 882-96.—Mansfield, R. D, & Lich, R, jr. Intracapsular fracture of the femoral neck. Hosp. News, Wash, 1941, 8: No. 21, 7-19.—Mensor, M. G, & Dewey, E T. Intracapsular fractures: neck of the femur; a statistical survey of end-results. California West. M, 1936, 44: 271-6 — Moorhead, J. J. Intracapsular fracture of the neck of the femur. J. Am. M. Ass, 1930, 95: 1494-7.—Ortiz Tirado. A. Tratamiento operatorio de las fracturas intracapsular del cuello del femur con una modificaci6n a la t6cnica de Albee. Rev. med, Puebla, 1942, 15: No. 141, 20-30.—Phemister, D. B intracapsular fractures of the neck of the femur. Canad. M Ass. J, 1932, 26: 431-3.—Pridie, K. H. Introduction of the Sinith-Pet'ersen pin in treatment of intracapsular fractures of the neck of the femur. Lancet, Lond, 1937, 2: 126-8.— Shatara, F. I. Extrusion of the Smith-Petersen nail in intra- capsular fractures of the neck of the femur. Am. J. Surg, 1941, 53: 32-40.—Smith-Petersen, M. N, Cave. E.F.. & Vangorder. G W Intracapsular fractures of the neck of the femur; treat- ment by internal fixation. Arch. Surg, 1931. 23: 715-59. ------ Intracapsular fractures of the neck of the femur treated bv nailinf. In Experience Managem. Fractures (Wilson, P. D.) Phila 1938, 893-940.—Speed, J. S. Central fractures of the neck of the femur; an analysis of the end results. J. Am. M. Ass 1935, 104: 2059-63. Also South Surgeon, 1938, 7: 19- 39^-Wade P. A. Intracapsular fractures of the neck of the femur; a study of 190 cases. Ann. Surg, 1938, 108: 440-63 — White W D Internal fixation in intracapsular fractures ot the neck of the femur. Minnesota M, 1938, 21: 358.—Williams, G Treatment of intracapsular fracture of the neck of the femur. Clin. J, Lond, 1934, 63: 21-3.-Willway, F. W Intra-capsular fractures of the neck of the femur: a survey of the rjresent-day methods of treatment. Med. Press & Circ, lond 1934 188: 312-6.—Wilson, M. J. Treatment of intra- capsular fractures of the neck fo the femur. Hahneman. Month, 1935, 70: 120-4. ____ Femoral neck: Fracture, latent. Ailkiaer V Ueber verborgene Frakturen im Collum femoris. Beitr. klin. Chir, 1935, 161: 548-64.-Di Prisco Le fratture complete latcnti del collo del femore Morgapi 1934, 76. 688—Ramond. L. Fracture latente du col du f6mur. Presse m6d, 1937, 45: 1061. ____ Femoral neck: Fracture: Military aspect. Heublein, W. Ein seltener Schenkelhalsbruch bei einem Soldaten und seine Bedeutung fiir den Truppenarzt. Deut. Mihtararzt, 193.9, 4: 412-6. HIP 660 HIP ---- Femoral neck: Fracture, multiple. Lugoney, C. Doble fractura del cuello anat6mico del femur. Rev. med. lat. amer, B. Air, 1028, 14: 178-87. Also Civil. med. mex, 1929, 28: 448-52.- \ iannay. Fracture k multiples fragments dc la region du col chirurgical du femur; desinsertion des muscles pelvi-tiochant6ricns et ligature osseuse; bon re.sultat anatomique et fonctionnel. Loire med, 1928, 42: 234-40. ---- Femoral neck: Fracture: Pathogenesis. Franz, J. *Ueber einon Fall von Schenkel- halsfraktur der AI utter wahrend der Geburt. 16p 8? Bresl., 1930. Brother, M. H. Fractura patologica del cuello del femur. Cn'n. med. mex, 1032, 31: 543-5.—Engcl. Zum Mechanismus der Srhcnkelhalsfiaktur. Verh. Deut. orthop. Ges. (1920) 1027. 21. Kongr, 130—Gissane, \V„ Blair, I), & Rank, B. h. Fractures of neck of the femur in convulsion therapy. Lancet, I/Ond., 1940, I: 450-3.—Giicke. Experimented' Beitrage zur Entstehung des Schenkelhalsbruches. Verh. Deut. orthop. Cie,, 27. Kongr. (1932) 1933, 87-92.—Ke> I. R. Beitrag zur Lnt-l< hunji cler Schenkelhalsbriiche. Arch, orthop. UnfaUchir, 1032. 31: 117 24.—Mathieu. P, & Padovani. P. Syphilis et fiactures du c.l du femur. Bull. med.. Par, 1033, 47: 605-7.— Odelberii-Jcihiison, G. Zur Entsiehung der medialen Kollum- fiaktur. Acta chir. scand, 1930, 67: 505-017.—Okrainetz, G. L, & IJillcr. S. B. Fracture of the neck of the femur complicat- ing Rxientjren thernpv of ovarian cancer. Am. .1. Koentg.. 1030, 42: 883-7.— I'eck, W. S. Fractures of the femoral neck follow- ing pelvic irradiation. Univ. Hosp. Bull, Ann Arb, 1939, 5: 33.—Sandner, 10, & Thompson, E. C. Causati' n of fractures of the neck i I the femur. Med. J. Australia, 1011, 2: No. 14 383-01. - - Scltink. W. Funktionelle Iiis'iflizionzcrseheimingon am Knoohon unter besonderer Berucksichtigung der sclueichen- di'ii 1'iaktiir des Schenkelhalses (ein Beitrag zur Frage de- Lcherlastungsschadens) Rontgen praxis, 1038. 10: 825-41.— Shkurov, If. I. |Pathogenesis of fractures of the collum femoris from the view point of its anatomico-physiological properties] Ortop. travmat, 1935, 9: 34-42.—Simeon, A. Considerations sur les causes predi.s|>osantes des fractures du col femoral. Arch. med. pharm. nav, 1020, 119: 432-9. ---- Femoral neck: Fracture: Pathology. Cubignv, M. *Etude analomo-pathologiquc de la tete femorale au cours des fractures du col. 90p. 8? Par., 1926. Corry, D. C. Drv fracture of neck of femur. -Brit. M. J, 1930, 1: 590.- Couch, J. II. The 2 fractures of the neck of the femur. Canad. M. .Vs. .1, 1940, 43: 31-4— Darrach, W, & Stimson, B. B. Displacements in fractures of the neck of the femur. Tr. Am. Surg. Ass, 1934, 52: 181-90. Also Ann. Surg, 1934, 100: 833-42—D'Harcourt, J, & D'Harcourt, M. Contribuci6n al estudio de la patologia de las fracturas recien tes del cuello dc femur y los fundamentos del tratamiento opera torio de estas fracturas. Rev. san. guerra, Barcel, 1937, 1: 37-52, 4 pl.— Freund. E. Leber die mikroskopischen Vorgiinge im Hiiftkopf nach Sehcnkelhal-brttchen. Virchows Arch, 1930, 277: 320-70. Hcvse. V. Ein Beitrag zur Anatomie und Therapie dor Schenkelhalsbriiche. Deut. Zschr. Chir, 1926, 1P9: 361-401 -Jones. R. Observations on fractures of the neck of the f< nuir. Brit, M. J, 1931 1: 781-5. Kreuz. Die Pathophvsiolegie des Schenkelhalsbruches und seine Behand- lung. Verh. Lent, orthop. Ges, 27. Kongr. (1932) 1033, 17- 37.—Madier. J. Les fractures du col anatomique du f6mur. Hopital, 1929, 17: 48-50.—Schwahn. Gehfahigkeit bei frischen Schenkelhalsbriichen. Arch, orthop. UnfaUchir, 1930, 28: 355-61.—Walter. Zur Pathologie und Histologie des Schenkel- halsbruches. Verh. Deut. orthop. Ges. (1932) 1933, 27. Kongr, 61-6. ---- Femoral neck: Fracture, spontaneous. Meurers, C. *Ueber das Vorkommen von Knochenschadigungen vor allem Spontanfrak- turen des Sehenkelhalses bei Scitenfelderbe- strahlung des Genitalkarzinoms [Wurzburg] 15p. 8? Ochsenfurt, 1935. NtlRNBERG, W. *Doppelseitigo Schenkelhals- spontanfraktur und Osteomalacic 40p. 8° Frankf. [1919] Raensch, W. Ueber Spontanfrakturen des Schcnkelhalses nach Rontgenbestrahlung. Rontgenpraxis, 1932, 4: 716.— Paker, L. D. Spontaneous fracture of the femoral neck follow- ing irradiation; report of a case. J. Bone Surg, 1941, 23: 354- 8.—Dalby, R. G, & Jacox, H. \V. Fracture of the femoral neck following irradiation therapv. Univ. Hosp. Bull Ann Arb 1935 1: 29.—Dalby. R. G.. Jarox, K. W. [et al.] 'Fracture of the femoral neck following irradiation. Am. J. Obst, 1936 32- 50 9, 11 pl.- Esser. J. F. S. Nouvelle methode d'articulatiori du femur apres fiacture spontan6e du col. Rev. chir struct Bnix, 1938, 8: 73-0 - Kropp, L. Ueber Spontanfrakturen des Schcnkelhalses nach Rontgenbestrahlungen wegen Uterus- karzinoms. Munch, med. Wschr, 1934. 81: 214.—Milliard, K. S. Spontaneous fracture of the apparently normal neck of the femur. Brit. J. Surg, 1941-42, 29: 241 -4.—Roederer, C, & Brainos, A. Fractures spontanees d'un col femoral d'un cote et de la diaphyse femorale de l'autre c6te k 3 ans do distance, chez un adulte n'etant atteint d'aucune affection nerveuse ou osseuse apparente. Bull. Soc. chir. Paris, 1938 30: 358-01. ---- Femoral neck: Fracture: Statistics. Gisler, K. * Ueber Schenkelhalsbriiche. 4()p S? Zur., 1933. Callahan, J. J. Fractures of the neck of the femur; 5 year collective review. Surg. Gyn. Obst, 1930. 68: Suppl, 411-8.— Carruthrrs. F. W. Fracture of the neck of the femur; report of 1(10 cases. South. M. J, 1930, 23: 1023 ,tre. Bull. Soc. chir. Paris, 1928, 20: 834-43. Also Paris chir, 1928, 20: 249-53.—Kulowski, J. Internal fixation of transcervical fractures of the femur. J. Missouri M. Ass., 1937, 34: 296-301. ----1— & Luck, J. V. Microscopic changes after internal fixation of transcervical fracture of the femur. J. Bone Surg, 1941, 23: 17-22.—Mathieu. Le traitement chirurgical des fractures transcervicales du col du femur. Rev. gin. clin. ther, 1936, 50: 209-11— Mocquot, P. Fracture transcervicale du f6rnur consplidee. Bull. Soc. nat. chir. Par, 1928, 54: 927.—Parcelier, A, & Chenut, A. L'arthrotomie dans l'ostr'o- synthese des fractures transcervicales du femur. Bordeaux chir, 1935, 6: 32.—Pouyanne, L. Fracture transcervicale du col du femur. J. med. Bordeaux, 1939, 116: pt 2, 212.— Robineau. Traitement operatoire des fractures transcervicales du col du femur. P. verb. Congr. fr. chir, 1924, 33: 171-7. Also Bull. Soc. nat. chir. Par, 1926, 52: 439-47— Sosa de Quesada, U. Clavo porta-injerto como tratamiento de las fracturas transcervicales y subcapitales del cuello femoral. Bol. Col. med. Camaguey, 1940-41, 3: 4 33-46. Also Cir. ortop. traumat, Habana, 1941, 9: 88-99— Vaquie, G. E. Cirugia 6sea; osteo-sintesis; tratamiento operatorio de las fracturas (cuello femur) trans-cervicales. Rev. med. Rosario, 1927, 17: 127: 183.—Westcott. H. H. Pre'iminary report of a method of internal fixation of transcervical fractures of the neck of the femur in the aged. Virginia M. Month, 1932, 59: 197-204. ------ A method for the internal fixation of trans- cervical fractures of the femur. J. Bone Surg, 1934, 16: 372- 8. Also South. M. & S, 1934, 96: 458-61—Wi=e. R. A. Histological study of a transcervical fracture of the femur after internal fixation. J. Bone Surg, 1941, 23: 941-7. ---- Femoral neck: Fracture: Treatment. Pauwels, F. Der Schenkelhalsbruch ein mechanisches Problem; Grundlagen des Heilungs- vorganges, Prognose und kausale Therapie. 158p. 8? Stuttg., 1935. Rebhuhn, N. *Contribution a l'etude des fractures dujcol du f6mur et de leur traitement. 20p. 22^cni. Lausanne, 1939. Schneiter, O. *Ueber die Behandlung der Schenkelhalsfrakturen [Zurich] 56p. 8? Wet- zikon, 1928. Bahls, G. Die Behandlung des Schenkelhalsbruches. Med. Welt, 1936, 10: 525-7. Also Zschr. arztl. Fortbild, 1939, 36: o53_5 —Bani, U. Trattamento delle fratture del collo del femore. Umbria med, 1935, 15: 2825; 2832; 2851.—Bass, J. M. [Treatment of fractures of the neck of the femur] Khirur- gia, Moskva, 1938, No. 5, 102-13.—Blencke, A. Der Schenkel- halsbruch und seine Behandlung. Zschr. iirztl. Fortbild, 1933, 30.g. 39—Roppe, M. Traitement des fractures recentes du col' du femur. J. chir. Par, 1933, 42: 340-01. Also Presse med 1935, 43: 1061-4.—Boyd, H. B. Treatment of acute fractures of the neck of the femur. South. Surgeon 1941, 10: 364-71 —Carothers, R. Fracture of the neck of the femur. Tr. South. Surg. Ass. (1925) 1926, 38: 95-9— Cordasco. P. Evolution of treatment of fracture of neck of femur. Arch. Surg 1938 37: 871-925.—Davis, J. W. The treatment of fractures of the neck of the femur. South. M. & S, 1939 101: 529-35 —Delbet, P. Traitement des fractures du col du femur. FoJ med, Rio, 1926, 7: 208-12.—Dupuy de Frenelle, M. Traitement des fractures recentes du col du femur. Hopital, 1039 27- 137-44—Galeazzi, R. Cura delle fratture del collo femorale." Gior. med. mil, 1930, 84: 1149-56-Gallant A. E. History of treatment of acute fractures of the femoral neck. Southwest. M, 1940, 24: 190-5.-Gissane, W Treatment o fracture of the neck of the femur. Lancet, Lond, 1937, 1. 479 —Glaessner, P. El tratamiento de las fracturas del cuello del femur. Dfa rued, B. Air, 1931-32, 4: 728.—Grinda, J. P. Traitement des fiactures du col du femur. Gaz med. France, 1936, 43: 427-34 -Gubern Salisachs, L. El tratamento delM fracturas del cuello del femur. Med ibera 1936 30: 488; iraciuiKs T_ Ueber d.e Behandlung der Schenkelhals- fraktur. Gun idan zasshi, 1934, No. 252: 3.-Hendcrson, M. S. Fractures of the neck of the femur Surg Chn N. America, 1990 9- 25-37—Hillebrand. Die Behandlung der Schenkel- halsbrttche. Munch, med. Wschr, 1933 80: 350.-Judet, H. La radiographic dc profil de la hanche dans le traitement des fractures du col du femur. Bull. Soc. chir. Pans, 1928 20. 73a£9' _Lorenz. A. Schenkelhalsfrakturen und ihre Behand- lunV Zschr. orthop. Chir, 1933-34, 60: 427-42-Loubal, Laporte F. [et al.) Sur un cas de decollement-fracture du col HIP 662 HIP du femur en 2 temps. Bordeaux chir, 1932, 3: 439.—Lozano, I). Tratamiento de la* fiacturas del cuello del femur. Rev. As med. argent, 19-10. 54: 105-7.—MacAusland, W. R, MacAusland, A. R, & Lee. H. G. Fractures of the neck of the femur. Surg. Gyn. Obst.. 1934, 58: 079-98.—Magnus, (i. Die Behandlung der Schenkelhalsfraktur. Deut. med. Wschr, 1936, 62: 957 60. Also Verh. Beil. med. Ges. (1936) 1937, 67: 32-40.—Martin. E. D. Fracture of the neck of the femur. Internat. .1. M. & S, 1933, 46: 301-0. -Mathieu, P. Fractures du col du femur. In Traite chir. on hop. (Ombredanne) Par, 1937, 4: 3271-303.—Mulier, M. Traitement des fractures du col du femur. Rev. med, Louvain, 1920, 304-12.—Nes, C. P. van [Treatment of fractures of the neck of the femur] Ned. t>cbr. geneesk, 1936. 80: 2909-11.—Newell, E. D, Frere, J. M„ A- Higuinbotham, J. M. The treatment of fractures of the neck of the femur. J. Tennessee M. Ass, 1940, 33: 427-31 — Nuboer, J. F. [Treatment of fracture of the neck of the femur] Ned. tschr. geneesk, 1937, 81: 3801-6.—Popesco-Severin, A. Le traitement des fractures du ct 1 femoral; auto-resume d'apres le rapport presente au 9in e Congr£s National dc Chirurgie, Novembre 1938. Rev. chir, Bucur, 1938, 41: 830-62.—Putti, V. Dircttive odierne nella cura delle fratture del collo del femore. Bibliogr. ortop, Bologna, 1938, 21: 313- 6.—Richard, M. Die Behandlung der Schenkelhalsfraktur. Schweiz. mod. Wschr, 1930, 60: 615-8.—Roegholt, M. N. [Treatment of fractures with special reference to fractures of the neck of the femur] Ned. tschr. geneesk, 1940, 84: 3881- 6.—Ruschli, E. B, & Sichler. H. G. The management of fractures of the neck of the femur. J. Indiana M. Ass, 1935, 28: 12] -3. --Sanchez Toledo, P. Tratamiento de las fracturas lecieiite.- del cuell<> del femur. Bol. Col. med. Camagiiey, 1940, 3:185-7. Scudder. C. L. Treatment of fracture of the nock of the femur. West Virginia M. J, 1937, 33: 193-7.—Shkurov, B. I. ITreatment of fractures of the neck of the femur] Ortop. travmat., 1935, 9: 84-96.—Weber, L. A. El tratamiento de las fracturas del cuello del femur. Dfa med, B. Air, 1940, 12: 21-3.—Whitman, R. A review of the campaign for the estab- lishment of surgical principles in the treatment of fracture of the neck in the femur. J. Bone Surg, 1938, 20: 960-2, The salvaging of fracture of the femoral neck. Lancet, Lond, 1942, 1: 378-80.—Wiles, P. Fractures of the neck of the femur. In Treat. Gen. Pract, Lond, 1940, 4: 348-56. ----Femoral neck: Fracture: Treatment: Ap- paratus, and instruments. Akerlung, A. Metallic scale indicators for use in nailing fractures of the neck of the femur. Acta radiol, Stockh, 1935, 16: 557-62, pl.—Albee, F. H. The autogenous bone-graft peg as a primary treatment for fractures of the neck of the femur. Internat. J. M. & S, 1931. 44: 505-11.—Boppe. Appareil-guide pour enclouage extra-articulaire des fractures du col du femur Mem. Acad, chir. Par, 1937, 63: 1243-5.—Boyd, D. A simple radiographic table for Smith-Petersen pinning of the femoral neck. Brit. J. Radiol, 1042, 15: 94.—Boyd, F. W. The use of the cow-horn peg in fractures of the neck of the femur, with special reference to types of fractures suitable for the use of the peg and method employed in introducing same. Viininia M. Month, 1940, 67: 77.—Brocq, P, & Dulot, R. Appareil per- mettant de realiser facilement et sans erreur po-^ible l'enchevil- lement des fractures du col du femur sans art loot mine ou apt 6s arthrotomie. P. verb. Congr. chir, 1934, 43: 03S-42 ANo Bull. Soc. nat. chir. Par, 1934, 60: 730-9.—Bunnell, S. Fracture of the neck of the femur; a sight for accurately direct- ing the dowel peg. Surg. Gyn. Obst, 1933, 57? 685-8.— Cadenat, F. M. Appareil pour enchevillement du col du femur Mem. Acad, chir. Par, 1938, 64: 49.—Chalochet, J. Une instrumentation geometrique, permettant l'enchevillement du col du femur avec precision et simplicite. P. verb. Congr. fr. chir, 1935, 44: 725-30.------L'enchevillement, le vissage ou la greffe du col du femur, rendus faciles et siirs avec I'appareil de l'auteur. Clinique, Par, 1938, 33: 133-6— Charbonnier, A. Appareil pour le rcperage du centre de la tete f6morale dans le vissage du col. P. verb. Congr. fr. chir, 1924, 33: 552-5.— Charry, R. Nuevo aparato simphficado de orientacion para la osteoslntesis del cuello de femur. Cir. ortop. traumat, Habana 1941, 9: 82-7.—Chatzkelson. B. Zur Behandlung der Schenkel- halsfrakturen mittels Geh-Schiene. Schweiz. med Wschr 1937, 67: 1049.—Cleary, E. W. An accessory table top which ehminates guesswork from extra-articular internal fixation of femoral-neck fractures. J. Bone Surg, 1938, 20: 449-53 ------ & Morrison, G. M. A self-released lock-bolt for frac- tures of the femoral neck. California West. M 1936 45- 279. Also Canad. M. Ass. J, 1937, 36: 409 Cochrane, W. a! Flexed plaster spica for fractured femoral neck Lancet Lond, 1941. 2: 726-8— Colby Engel, G, & May, H. Two- plane direction finder for nailing fractures of neck of femur Surg. Gyn. Obst.. 1038, 66: 49.5-9.—Compere. E. L, Wallace! G, 44-327- 38.—Cubbins. W. R., Callahan, J. J., & Scuderi, C. S. Frac- tures of the neck of the femur; open operation and pathologic observations; a new incision and a new director for the u-e of a simplified flange. Surg. Gyn. Obst, 1939, 68: 87-94 —Dean J. C. Protractor for use in nailing fractured neck of femur' Wisconsin M J, 1938, 37: 115.—Ducroquet, R. Appareils pl&tres pour fracture du col femoral decouvrant la region tro- chantenenne et permettant au malade de s'asseoir Bull Soc. nat. chir. Par, 1933, 59: 675-88—Engel, G. C.,'& May H. Two-plane direction and range finder for nailing fracturea of the neck of the femur. J. Am. M. Ass, 1038, 110: 1828.— Exalto, J. Beitrag zur Smith-Petersenschen Rehandlungswcise der Schenkelhalsfraktur unter Verwendung eines neuen Richt- apparates. ^ Chirurg, 1935, 7: 873-81.—Fitte, M. Aplicaci6n del tirabuzi'vn en las fracturas del cuello femoral. Bol. Soc cir B. Aires, 1938, 22: 593-605.— Frere, J. M. The role of X-ray in the diagnosis and treatment of fractured hips. Indust. M 1940, 9: 400-4.—Godoy-Moreira. F. E. A special stud-bolt screw for fixation of fractures on the neck of the femur I Bone Surg.. 1940, 22: 6S3 97.—Golden, U. I. Simplified appli- cator for localization of the angle of the neck and shaft of the femur, and a director for guidance to internal fixation. J Internat. Coll. Surgeons, 1940, 3: 73-7.-- Grigoresru. I. I. [Value of Royal Whitman's therapeutic method in fractures oi the femoral neck] Rev. st. med, Bucur, 1930, 25: 1032-57.__ Hallauer, E. Behandlung der Schenk< Ilials-Frakturen der Jugendlichen durch eine kombinicrte \\ hitman-Kxtensions- melhode. Schweiz. med. Wschr, 1938, 68: 344-6.—Hart, V. L. Fracture of the femoral neck; bilateral hip spica immobilization' Surg. Gyn. Obst, 1933, 57: 788.—HofThein. S. Ein neues Hilfsinstrument fur die Schenkelhalsnagelung. Zbl Chir 1938, 05: 2266-8.—Hunsucker, W. C, & Jennings, D. The use of the well-leg splint in treatment of intertrochanteric fraetiurs of the femur. South. M. & S, 1940, 102: 239-41.—Hustinx. 10. lnsliument zur Nagelung von Sehenkelhalsbrtlchen. Zbl Chir, 1937, 64: 2316-20.— Iovino, F. Callo deforuie e tra/ione col filo. Riforma med, 1933, 49: 1349-55. -James, F, S. Yitallium cups and Smith Petersen nails. Canad. Nurse 1941 37: 541-4.—Jones, R. W. The Smith-Petersen nail. Lancet Lond, 1935, 2: 217.—Judet, H. Traitement des fractures du col du f6mur par I'appareil pldti-e de Whitman modifie. P verb. Congr. fr. chir, 1933, 42: 1114-6.—Kast, H. Ueber eine neue Idee zur operativen Fixicrung der Schenkelhalsfraktur mit patienteigenem Material (mit Versuchen an der Leiche) Zbl. Chir, 1938, 65: 1446-50.—Kindersley, C. E. Director for the insertion of Smith-Petersen nails. Lancet, Lond, 1939, 1: 990.—Kleinberg, S. The value of nearly weight-bearing in the treatment of fractures of the neck of the femur. J. Bone Surg, 1937, 19: 904-77.—Krapp, H. Richtungszeiger zum Einfuhren von Kirschnerdrahten bei der Nagelung beziehungsweise Ver- schraubung der Schenkelhalsfraktur. Zbl. Chir, 1935, 62: 2706-9.—Kuntscher, G. Zwei neue Hilfsmittel fur die Nage- lung des Schenkelhalsbruches. Ibid, 1936, 63: 689-94. ----- Haitevorrichtung fiir den Richtungsbestimmer zur Nagelung des Schenkelhalses. Ibid, 1937, 64: 66-8.—Lehmann, K. A new aiming and guiding instrument for osteosynthesis frac- turae colli femoris ad modum Sven Johansson. Acta chir. scand, I93C 37. 79: 20-34, pl.—Lippincott. W. M. Fracture na.il_giiugo and applicator. U. S. Patent Off, 1941, No. 2,207,157.-—Lippmann, R. K. A new device for securing and maintaining compression in femoral neck fractures. J. Mount Sinai Hosp. N. Vork, 1936-37, 3: 65-73.—Lloyd, E. I. A director for the insertion of the Smith-Petersen nail in collum femoris fractures. Lancet, Lond, 1935, 2: 129-31.—Longfellow, E. E. Surgical threaded nail and method of applying same. U. S. Patent Off, 1942, No. 2,270,188.—Lorenzo, F. A. Molybdenum steel lag screw in internal fixation of fractured neck of femur. Surg. Gyn. Obst, 1941, 73: 99-104, pl.—Manson. Appareil k traction continue pour fracture de la diaphyse femorale et du col du femur. Bull, med. Par, 1940, 54: i.59.—Marziani, B. Un nuovo strumentario per l'avvitamento delle fratture del collo femorale; il divaricatore-guida autostatico. Arch, ortop, Milano, 1940, 56: 29-46.—Mathieu, P. Appareil de vis6e pour enclouage du col du femur. Mem. Acad, chir. Par, 1936, 52: 32-6.—Michailowsky. Traitement des fractures fermeijs du col chirurgical de l'humerus par I'appareil a extension continue du Dr Proeger, avec modification du Dr Michailowskv. Bull. Soc. nat. chir. Par, 1933, 59: 1003.—Miller, O. R. The use ol the Roger Anderson well-leg counter-traction splint in fractures of the neck of the femur. Kentucky M. J, 1933, 31: 573-6 — Morrison, G. M. Device for treating fractures of the heck of the femur. U. S. Patent Off, 1937, No. 2,077,804, pl — Nowotny, H. Die Schenkelhalsklammer, ein Richtinstrument zur Nagelung des Schenkelhalsbruches. Zbl. Chir, 1938, 65: 1290-3— Nuboer, J. F. [Use of a two-pronged spike in osteo- synthesis in fractures of the neck of the femur] Ned. tschr. geneesk, 1940, 84: 1368-74, 3 pl—Pidcock, B. H. Modified Smith-Petersen nail. Brit. M. J, 1936, 2: 1145.—Pogorclsky, M. A. [Whitmann's bandage in fractures of the neck of the femur] Ortop. travmat, 1937, 11: 91-4, 2 pl.—Portable CA) dark-room for use in the Johannson operation. Irish .1. M. Sc, 1935, 6. ser, 658-61.—Poulsson, A. Demonstration of an apparatus for the purpose of directing the nails in case* of fractura colli femoris. Acta chir. scand, 1940, 84: 280 — Rendu, A. Guide k reglettes pour l'enclouage des fractures du col du femur. Avenir med. Par, 1938, 35: 248-52- Rossi. B. Un nuovo modello del mio lettino da trazione con dispnsitivn per l'mcavigliamento del collo femorale alia Delbet, Clin. chir Milano. 1929, 32: 381-404.—Santy, P. Fracture cervico- troehnnterienne anterieurement traitee par un platre de Whit- mans Lyon chir, 1933, 30: 117.—Schmid, W. Instrument zur achsengerechten Drahtfuhrung bei der Behandlung der Sohenkelhalsfraktur. Zbl. Chir, 1937, 64: 2389-90.—Sloat, J. I, & Peterson, L. T. A new device for facilitating the taking of roentgenograms when performing the extra-articular method of internal fixation in fractures of the femoral neck. J. Bone Surg, 1939, 21: 1041-4.—Struppler, V. Peilinstrument zur sichercn Einlegung von Fuhrungsdrahten fur Nagel oder Schrauben am HIP 663 HIP Schenkelhals. Zbl. Chir, 1939, 66:1285-8.—Thomson, J. E. M. The treatment of fractures of the neck of the femur by double leg casts in fixed traction and triangle truss support. Surg. Gyn. Obst, 1928, 47: 101-4.— Unger, E, & Lagemann, C. Zur Behandlung der Schenkelhalsfraktur im Gipsverband. Med. Klin, Berl, 1926, 22: 1840.—Vails. Appareil de visee pour enclouage du col du femur. Mem. Acad, chir. Par, 1937, 63: 640.— Vails, J, & Lagomarsino, E. H. Technik und neues Fuhrungsinstrument fiir die extraartikulare Nagelung von Schenkelhalsbriichen. Zbl. Chir, 1937, 64: 1170-6—Vov- chenko, G. V. [Moore's bandage in fractures of the neck of the femur| Khirurgia, Moskva, 1939, No. 9, 98-101.—Whitman, R. Fractured femoral neck. Lancet, Lond, 1942, 1: 57. --- Femoral neck: Fracture: Treatment: Methods. Bohler, L., & Jeschke, W. Operative Be- handlung der Schenkelhalsbriiche. 201p. 24}2cm. Wien, 1938. Cohen, H. *Die operative Aufrichtung det Schenkelhalses [Berlin] 31p. 8? [Zossen] 1928. Eicken, F. *Ueber operative Behandlung alter Schenkelhalsbriiche mit Kopfhalsresektion und Einpfianzung des grossen Rollhugels in die Hiiftpfanne auf Grund einiger Erfahrungen der Chirurgischen Klinik Munchen. 25p. 8° Miinch., 1929. Grinda-Blairon, F. *Notes sur le traite- ment des fractures cervicales vraies du col femoral. 47p. 8? Par., 1937. Hartelt, A. [J. A.] *Der Schenkclhalsbrucl: und seine Behandlung in der chirurgischen Uni- versitatsklinik zu Greifswald. 40p. 22^cm. Greifswald, 1938. Hodenberg, D. v. *Ergebnisse der Tro- chanterimplantation bei Schenkelhalsfrakturen. 24p. 21cm. Berl., 1936. Johansson, S. The operative treatment of collum femoris fractures. 148p. 8? Kbh., 1934. Levetjf, J. B. Le traitement des fractures du col du femur par la methode du professeur Pierre Delbet. 143p. 8? Par., 1927. Metzger, B. *Ueber die Behandlung des veralteten Schenkelhalsbruches durch subtro- chantere Osteotomie. 20p. 22cm. Koln, 1936. Neumann, S. Conservative oder operative Behandlung der Schenkelhals-Frakturen. 31p. 22^cm. Berl., 1938. Ryan, P. *Fractures of the neck of the femur; evolution of the treatment [St Mary's Hosp.] 18 1. 28cm. Milwaukee, 1941. Akin, O. F. Conservative treatment of fracture of the neck of the femur. West. J. Surg, 1937, 45: 603-7.—Albee, F. H. Treatment of fractures of the neck of the femur. J. Florida M. Ass, 1931, 18: 11-6. ------ Importance of restoration of blood supply in fractures of neck of femur. J. Am. M. Ass, 1938, 110: 2044-8.—Alglave. Au sujet du traitement sanglant des fractures du col du femur. Bull. Soc. nat. chir. Par, 1935, 61: 1267-9.—Andersen, K. Ueber die Behandlung der Schen- kelhalsbriiche. Acta chir. Scand, 1935, 76: 457-71, 6 pl — Apfelbach, G. L, & Aries. L. J. Ambulatory treatment of fractures of the neck of the femur. Surg. Gyn. Obst, 1936, 63: 341-8.—Arnaud, L. Traitement des fractures fermees du col du femur par la methode de Delbet. P. verb. Congr. fr. chir.. 1924, 33: 167-70.—Barbarin, P. Traitement non sanglant des fractures du col du femur. Ibid, 1923. 32: 768-70.—Becker, S. Ueber die Behandlung der Schenkelhalsbruche. Deut. Zschr. Chir, 1938, 250: 535-8.—Bernaldez. Resultados e indicaciones del metodo de extension de Kirschner en el trata- miento de las fracturas del cuello femoral. Med. ibera, 1934, 28: 628.—Blanchard, Charbonnel & Papin, E. Procede nou veau pour le traitement des fractures du col du femur. Bor- deaux chir, 1933, 4: 405. Also J. med. Bordeaux, 1933, 110: 451-4.—Boppe. Fracture par decapitation du col femoral; reduction sanglante par arthrotomie; enclouage par le clou de Smith-Petersen; guerison. Bull. Soc. nat. chir. Par, 1933, 59: 865-7.—Borchard, A. Zur Frage der Behandlung von Schenkel- halsbriichen. Beitr. klin. Chir, 1936, 163: 112-6. Also Deut. med. Wschr, 1937, 63: 45-8.—Brackett, E. G. Fractured neck of the femur; operation-of transplantation of femoral head to trochanter; report of case showing result 8 years after operation Boston M. & S. J, 1925, 192: 1118-20—Breip. Zur Behand- lung des Schenkelhalsbruches. Chirurg, 1937, 9: 923-6.— Burman, M. S. Gridding the femoral head and neck area m fracture of neck of femur. Am. J. Surg, 1936, 34: 237-40.— Campos Kunhardt, J. Tratamiento quirurgico de las fracturas m1 oQei^odel£mulen los adult°s- Gac. med. Mexico, 1932, ihL 236T42-—Carothers, R. G. The treatment of fractures of the neck of the femur. Internat. J. Surg, 1925, 38- 176-9 — leballos, A, & Gioia, T. Fractutas del cuello del femur-'su tratamiento quirurgico. Sem. med, B. Air, 1928 35- 1449- 69 —Chavez L Estado actual del tratamiento de las fracturas del cuello del femur Cir. cirujan, Mex, 1937, 5: 453-82. Also Pacific Coast M, 1938, 5: No. 2, 17-23.—Cleary, E W I'racture of the neck of the femur: significant advances in treatment. California West. M, 1936, 44: 6.—Dawkins, A L 1 he treatment of recent fractures of the neck of the femur by subtrochanteric osteotomy. Austral. N. Zealand J. Sum- 1940-41, 10: 244-8.—Denis, R, & Cuilleret, F. Au sujet du traitement des fractures du col du femur. Lyon chir, 1939 36: 606-13.—Descarpentries, M. Traitement chirurgical ' des Fractures du col du femur. Arch. fr. belg. chir, 1933-34 34- 163-9, 2 pl. Also Echo med. nord, 1934, 3. ser, 2: 438.— Donald, D. The treatment of fractures, with s >ecial reference to fracture of surgical neck of humerus. Med. J. Australia, 1940, 1: 858-60.—Duefio, F. P. El tratamiento de los fracturas del cuello del femur. Arch, med, Madr, 1929, 31: 346-52.— Dupuy de Frenelle. Traitement operatoire des fractures du col du femur. P. verb. Congr. fr. chir, 1924, 33: 231-4. ------ Fracture du col du femur vissee par 3 vis depuis plus de 5 ans. Bull. Soc. chir. Paris, 1934, 26: 513-5. ------ Les fractures du col du femur et leur traitement. Techn. chir. Par, 1938, 30: 97-123.—Di Giorgi, G. Considerazioni sul trattamento curativo delle fratture del collo del femore. Cultura med. mod. Pal, 1933, 12: 141-52.—Ettorre, E. L'osteotomia sottotro- canterica nelle fratture del collo del femore. Chir. org. movim , 1934, 20: 529-40.—Evans, F, T. New advances in the treat- ment of fracture of neck of the femur. Wisconsin M. J, 1938, 37: 198-200.—Felfenreich, F. Die Operation des Schenkel- halsbruches. Beitr. klin. Chir, 1934, 160: 620. ------ Operative Behandlung des lateralen und intertrochantaren Schenkelhalsbruches. Zbl. Chir.. 1935, 62: 2405-9.—Ferre. La eleccion de tecnica en las fracturas basicervicales del cuello del femur. Med. ibera, 1934, 28: 775.—Finochietto, R. Frac- tura del cuello del femur; resultado obtenido con el metodo de Rardenheurer. Prensa med. argent, 1926-27, 13: 1198-200.— Fitte. El tratamiento de las fracturas antiguas del cuello del femur por la osteotomfa subtrocanterica. Bol. Acad, argent cir, 1940, 24: 839-41.—Fouchou-Lapeyrade. Un traitement simple et efficace des fractures du col femoral. Rev. gin. clin. ther, 1936, 50: 406-8.—Garceau, G. J, & Cogland, S. Early physical therapy in the treatment of fractures of the surgical neck of the humerus. J. Indiana M. Ass, 1941, 34: 293-5.— Gazeley, W. E, & Reich, G. A. Treatment of fracture of the neck of the femur and slipping of the femoral epiphysis. Albany M. Ann, 1938, 57: 146-50.—Gerlach, G. Zur Behandlung der Schenkelhalsfrakturen und der pertrochantersn Oberschenkel- frakturen. Arch, orthop. UnfaUchir, 1933, 33: 476-9.—Gill, A. B. Treatment of fractures of the neck of the femur. Ann. Surg, 1932, 96:1-16.-—Gioia, T. Contribuci6n al tratamiento de las fracturas del cuello del femur. Sem. med. B. Air, 1935, 42: 1188-94.—Girode, C. Traitement des fractures du col du femur chez l'adulte. J. med. chir. Par, 1928, 99: 242-50.— Godoy Moreira, F. E. Contribuicao ao tratamento das frac- turas do collo femural. Fol. med, Rio, 1938, 19: 25.—Gollasch. Zur Behandlung des Schenkelhalsbruches. Mschr. Unfallh, 1941, 48: 69-71.—Groves, E. W. H. Modern treatment of fractures of the neck of the femur. Ulster M. J, 1937. 6: 266.— Hansen, P. N. Traitement des fractures du col du f Imur. P. verb. Congr. fr. chir, 1924, 33: 151-5.—Haydon-Blillie. M. Fractures of the femoral neck. Lancet, Lond, 1942 1: 459.— Henderson, M. S, & Macey, H. B. Treatment of fractures of the neck of the femur. Surg. CUn. N. America, 1935, 15: 1199- 206.—Hendon, G. A. Presentation of patients with fracture of the neck of the femur treated by the Key method. Kentucky M. J, 1936, 34: 42-4—Hill, H. A, & Garland, L. H. The radiological aspects of the management of fractures of the femoral neck. Proc. Congr. Panpacific Surg. Ass, 1939, 295- 302.—Hoffheinz, S. Kritische Betrachtungen zu modernen Behandlung der Schenkelhalsfrakturen. Arch. klin. Chir, 1941, 201: 584-96 (microfilm)—Jerusalem, M. Zur operativen Behandlung der Schenkelhalsbruche. Chirurg, 1932, 4: 773- 80.—Jimeno-Vidal, F. Nota previa sobre el tratamiento de las fracturas del cuello del femur. Rev. cir. Barcelona, 1934, 8: 32-8.—Johansson, S. On the operative treatment of fractura colli femoris. Acta orthop. scand, 1932, 3: 362-92 '([Dis- cussion] 1933, 4: 73-7. ------ Operative treatment in certain forms of lateral collum femoris fractures. Ibid, 1933, 4: 228- 33.—Jones, A. R. The treatment of fracture of the neck of the femur. Practitioner, Lond, 1929, 122: 21-7.—Jones E. Trochanteric transplantation in the treatment of fractures of the neck of the femur. J. Bone Surg, 1932, 14: 259-66.— Bidet, H. Traitement des fractures du col du femur. P. verb. Congr. fr. chir, 1924, 33: 216-23.------La radiographic de profil de la hanche dans le traitement des fractures du col du femur. Paris chir, 1928, 20: 208-13. ------ Traitement des fractures du col du femur. P. verb. Congr. fr. chir, 1930, 39: 449-55.—Kreuz, L. Huftgelenkskapsel und Schenkelhals- bruch; eine anatomisch-rontgenologische Studie zur Lagebe- Stimmung und konservativen Behandlung der Schenkelhals- fraktur. Arch. klin. Chir, 1925, 137: 401-37.—Kusa, P. [New treatment in fracture of the neck of the femur] Medicina, Kaunas, 1938, 19: 697.—Lambotte. Sur le traitement opera- toire des fractures du col femoral. P. verb. Congr. fr. chir, 1924. 33; 155-61,—Lange, F. Die Behandlung der Schenkel- HIP 664 HIP halsbruche. Munch, med. Wschr, 1932. 79: 1562-!>. Lazza- rini. L. II trattamento delle fratture del collo del femoie. < uizz. osp, 1929, 50: 33-5— Leadbetter, G. W. A treatment for fracture of the neck of the femur. J. Bone Surg, 1933, 15: 9:11 40. ------ Non-operative treatment for fracture of the neck of the femur. Am. J. Surg, 1937, 38: 612-8.—Lehmann, K. [Recent data on operative treatment of fresh and old frac- tures of the femoral neck with special reference to the author's experience with Linden's method] Ugeskr. laeger, 1941, 103: 1201-8.—Lord, J. P. Treatment of fractures of femoral neck by open operation. Nebraska M. J, 1932, 17: 77.—McMurray, T. P. Fracture of the neck of the femur treated bv oblique osteotomy. Brit. M. J, 1938, 1: 330-3.—Magnuson, P. B. Fracture of the neck'of the femur; evaluation of the various methods advanced for treatment. J. Am. M. Ass, 1936, 107: 1439-45. Also Nebraska M. J, 1937, 22: 351.—Marottoli, O. R. Tratamiento de las fracturas antiguas del cuello del femur por la osteotomfa suhtrocanterica. Bol. Acad, argent, cir, 1940, 24: 728; 1012.—Mathieu, P. Traitement des fractures cervicales pures du l'extremite superieure du femur. Bull, med. Par, 1936, 50: 49-54.------Le traitement chirurgical des fractures cervicales du femur. Rev. med. Suisse rom, 1937, 57: 555.—Mercer, W. Fractures of the neck of the femur; their treatment; a review. Edinburgh M. J, 1940, 47: 317-35.— Merle D'Aubigne, R. Etat actuel du traitement des fractures du col du femur. Gaz. med. France, 1939, 46: 743-6.— Meyerding, H. W, & Pollock, G. A. Acute fractures of the neck of the femur; development of the treatment. Am. J. Surg, 1939, 46: 292-9.—Neuber, E. [New therapeutic methods in fracture of femoral neck| Orv. hetil, 1937, 81: 1120-3.— Nicole, R. Die Indikation beim Schenkelhalsbruch. Deut. Zschr. Chir, 1938-39, 251: 683-756.—Nowilzky, S. Zur operativen Behandlung der Schenkelhalsfrakturen. Arch. orthop. UnfaUchir, 1931, 30: 516-29.—Olivares, L. Traite- ment des fractures du col du femur. Opera Internat. Congr. Indust. Accid. (1928) 1929, 5. Congr, 331-5.- Palagi. P. Sul trattamento delle fratture del collo femorale. Arch, ortop, Milano, 1934, 50: 715-29.—Parcelier, A, & Chenut, A. Evolu- tion du greffon peronier dans 2 observations de fractures du col. Bordeaux chir, 1931, 2: 397-402.—Poulsson. A. [Operative treatment of fracture of the neck of the femur] Norsk mag. laegevid, 1938, 99: [Forh. kir. foren. Oslo] 92-110.—Putti, V. Indirizzo e metodica nella cura delle fratture del collo del femore. Chir. org. movim, 1937-38, 23: 399-429.------ La cura chirurgica delle fratture del collo del femore; cineniato- grafia. Bui}, sc. med, Bologna, 1939, 111: 129. Rabinavicius. S. [Operative tieatment of fracture of the neck of the femur] Medicina, Kaunas, 1938, 19: 097.—Riches, E. W. Fractured neck of the femur treated bv injection of blood. Brit. M. J, 1931, 1: 308- Robison, J. S. Fractures of the neck of the femur; a general consideration of some of the methods of treat- ment and special lolerenee to the use of the two-plane direction and range finder of Engle and May. J. Indiana M. Ass, 1940, 33: 520-2.—Roederer, C. Traitement non sanglant des fractures du col du f6mur. Clinique, Par, 1930, 25: 354-6.— Romney, H. Tratamiento de las fracturas del cuello del femui mediante la tecnica de Godoy-Moreira. Rev. med. cir. Habana, 1941, 46: 547-71.—Rosenberg, K. Die therapeutische Indi- kation der Schenkelhalsfraktur. Ausz. Inaugur. Diss. Med Fak: Univ. Bern (1935-37) 1938, No. 235, 1.—Sanchez Toledo, P. Tratamiento quirtirgico de la fractura del cuello del femur. Cir. ortop. traumat, Habana, 1940, 8: 135-44.—Sauerbruch, F, & Bergmann. E. Zur Behandlung der Schenkelhalsbriiche' Arch, orthop. UnfaUchir, 1930, 28: 341-7.—Schirmer, H. Zur Behandlung der Schenkelhalsfraktur. Chirurg, 1931, 3: 852-5.—Schumm, H. C. The Schanz osteotomy for fractures; of the neck of the femur. J. Bone Surg, 1937, 19: 955-63.— Serra, A. Zur Behandlung der Schenkelhalsfraktur durch Langszug in Adduktionsstellung. Chirurg, 1933, 5: 168.— Shands, A. R. Fracture of the neck of the femur and the treat- ment. Internat. J. Surg, 1925, 38: 371-3.—Simon, H. T. Conservative and operative treatment of fractures of the neck of the femur. N.Orleans M. & S. J, 1941-42, |94: 119-23.__ Tarafa, J. I. Tratamientos conservadores o incruentos de las fracturas del cuello del femur. Cir. ortop. traumat, Habana 1940, 8: 124-34.—Tavernier. A propos du traitement des fractures du col du femur. Lyon chir, 1939, 36: 634-7.— Terencio Gioia. Tratamiento operatorio de las fracturas del cuello del femur. Rev. brasil. med. form, 1928, 4: 428-35__ TrSves, A. Traitement orthopedique des fractures du col du fe- mur. P. verb. Congr. fr. chir, 1924, 33: 224-7.—Valis, J A prop6sito del tratamiento de las fracturas antiguas del cuello delfemur por la osteotomla intertrocanterea. Bol. Acad, argent cir, 1940, 24: 872-6.------■ Consideraciones sobre el tratamiento cruento de las fracturas del cuello del femur An Fafo". cienc. med. La Plata. 1937,1:147-50.------OUoIenghi C. E.. & Girardi, V. C. El tratamiento incruento de las frac- ture^ del cuello del femur. Ibid, 277-81.—Voss, O. Die Operation des Schenkelhalsbruches. Beitr. klin Chir 1934 160^: 291; 622.-1* hite, J. W. A step forward in the treatment' of fractures of the femoral neck. South. Surgeon 1936 5- 101-5.—White, WC. Treatment of fiactures of the neck of the femur. N. \ ork State J. M, 1925, 25: 966-8.—Whitman K. 1 he treatment of fracture of the neck of the femur Am J Surg, 1929, n. ser, 6: 799. Also J. Lancet, 1932, 52: 141-3 — Wiles, P. Fractures of the neck of the femur Brit M I 1939, 2: 920-2.-Wilkie. D. P. D. The treatment of fracture of the neck of the femur. Surg. Gyn. Obst, 1927, 44: 529. ---- Femoral neck: Fracture: Treatment: Os- feosyntliesis. Egidi, G. L'incliiodanicnto sottocutnneo delle fratture di collo femorale. 90p. 8? Borna, 1936. Ucssclaar, H. J. Fracture of the neck of the femur treated with ^mith Petersen-.Johansson nail fixation. S. Afr M J 1934, 18: 705-11.— Bilhaut * Rilhaut. His. Traitement'des fractures anciennes du col du femur par enclouage. Rev path comp. Par. 1920, 20: 120-8. Holder, L. Nagelung von Schenkelhalsbruchen. Wien. klin. Wschr, 1936, 4!t: 1344 Also Aerztl. Prax, Wien, 1937, 11: 179-81.—Boerema, I. Irrefuhrende Rontgenbilder beim genagclten Schcnkclh'al* briiche. Zbl. Chir, 1938, 65: 2156-63.—Bonadeo Ayrolo. ,\. Gufa para el enclavijamiento del cuello del femur sin ar'tro- tomfa. Rev. med, B. Air, 1940, 2: 764-8.—CaldweU. J. A. Fracture of the neck of the femur: treatment by immediite fixation. Ohio M. J, 1937, 33: 30-5.—Campbell. W. ('. Internal fixation in fractures of the neck of the femur Tr South. Surg. Ass, 1936, 49: 316-28. Also Ann. Surg,'l937^ 105: 939-51. •------ Treatment of fractures of the neck of Ihe femur by internal fixation. Southwest. M, 1940, 24: 3-7.—Carothcrs, R. G. The principles involved in the opera- tion for internal fixation of fractures of the neck of the femur Indust. M, 1940, 9: 249-51.— Charbonnicr. A. Reperage] reduction et vissage des fractures du o,,I du f6mur. Rev. med' Suisse rom, 1932, 52: 083.—Dalziel, G. Treatment of fracture of the femoral neck by pinning. Tr. R. Med. Chir. Soc Glasgow, 1938-39, 33: 15-20— Davis. J. W. The treatment of fracture of the neck of the femur with the Smith-Petersen nail South. M. & S, 1938, 100:45-9—DenU, R. Au sujet de renchevillemcnt du col du femur. Lyon chir, 1936, 33: 244- 53. - —- & Cuillcrct, F. Notes compiementaires au sujet de l'enchevillement du col du f6mur. Ibid, 1939, 36: 637-9.•— Diaz, G. Ueber die Osteosvnthcsc der Fractura colli femoris Zbl. Chir, 1934, 61: 027-30.—Dupuy de Frenelle. Osteo- synthese du col du femur pair vissage. Bull. Soc. chir Paris, 1933, 25: 544-54. Also Techn. chir. Par, 1933, 25: 253; 1934, 26: 29. ------ Le vissage femoro-cotyloldien. Ibid, 1937. 29: 13-23.—Felsenreich, F. Osteosynthese bei Schenkelhalsfrakturen. Wien. klin. Wschr, 1936, 49: 787 Also Wien. med. Wschr, 1936, 86: 1194-9. ------ ForU schrittc auf dem Gebiete der Schcnkelhalsnagelung unter besonderer Berucksichtigung der an der II, < 'hirurgisclien Klinik in Wien geiibten Technik. Chirurg, 1938, 10: 509 80. Garcia Diaz, F. Sobre el tratamiento de las fracturas recientes del cuello del femur por ostcosintesis. Rev. cir. Barcelona, 1933, 6: 230-7.—Gruca, A. Le traitement des fractures du col du femur par l'enchevillement sous-eutane. Mem. Acad, chir Par, 1939, 65: 510-20. -Hampton, O. P., & Stewart. J. e! Internal fixation of fractures of the neck of the femur. .1 Missouri M. Ass, 1939, 36: 478-84. -Harcourt. d'. Contri- buci6n al estudio del problema biol6gico de las fracturas del cuello del femur; indicaciones de la osteosfntcsis por el clavo de Smith-Petersen en estas fracturas. Med. ibera, 1936, 30: pt 2, 282.—Henderson, M. S. Internal fixation of fractures of the neck of the femur. Arch. Surg, 1937, 35: 419-30. Also Radiol. Rev, 1937, 59: 132-6. Also Ann. Surg, 1938, 107: 132-42. Also Surg. Clin. N. America, 1939, 19: 927-42 — Hoffheinz. Nagelung des Oberschenkelhalses bei Frakturen. Zbl. Chir, 1938, 65: 2062.—Injections (Les) de pate d'os vivant dans les fractures du col du femur. Clinique, Par, 1930, 31: 2.—Junker. Richtungsbestimmung des Fuhrungsdrahtes bei dor extraartikuliiren Osteosynthese der Schenkelhalsfraktur. Chirurg, 1941, 13: 154.—Katz, P. [On osteosynthesis in medial fractures of the neck of the femur] Nov. khir. arkh, 1904-41, 48: 140.—King, D., Leef, E., & Terwilliger, C. K. The im- portance of accurate roentgenography and interpretation in femoral-neck fractures treated by internal fixation. .1. Bone Surg, 1940, 22: 168-70.—Masmonteil, F. Osteosynthese dee fractures du col du femur. In Pract. chir. illustree (Pauchet, V.) 3. ed, Par,, 1932, 18: 211-22.—Maynard, R. L. Nailing of fractured necks of femur. Tr. N. England Surg. Soc, 1939. 22: 248-o9.—Monberg, A. Cinematographic demonstration of osteosynthesis in fracture of the neck of the femur and wedge- shaped osteotomy of the tibia. Acta orthop. scand, 1938, 9: 230-3.—Muileder, A. Ueber die Nagelung eines Falles von 1-ractura colli femoris inveterata. Zbl. Chir, 1936, 63: 629- 31.—Ostrowski, S. Zur Richtungsbestimmung des Bohrkanals bei der Verschraubung von Schenkelhalsbruchen. Beitr. klin. Chir, 1926, 138: 368-81 [Bemerkung von Moritz Borchardt] 3»1.—Pineiro Sorondo, J, & E«-perne, P. Sobre el acceso a la cadera por la via de Smith-Petersen. lie v. As. med. argent, 1939, 53: 1124-6.—Plummer, W. W. Comments on internal Ration in fresh fractures of the neck of the'femur. J. Bone Surg, 1938, 20: 97-107.—Polak, E. [Extra-articular osteosynthesis in fracture of the neck of the femur] Cas. lek. Cesk, 1940, 79: 369-72, 4 pl.—Rankin, J. O. The treatment of fractures of the neck of the femur by internal fixation. Ann. Surg, 1940, 111: 3L>-26.—Richard, M. Einfache Richtungsbestimmung zur Schraubung der Schenkelhalsfraktur. Zbl.' Chir, 1931, 58: 837-9.—Rocher, H. L. Quelques reflexions k propos de l'acces sur la hanche de l'incision de Smith Petersen. Bordeaux chir, 1935, 6: 244. Also J. med. Bordeaux, 1935, 112: 407. ----- Dedoublement de la .Crete iliaque (barrette iliaque) dans l'inci- sjon de Smith-Petersen. Techn. chir. Par, 1935, 27: 103-7.— Smith, E. T. Treatment of fractures of the neck of the femur HIP 665 HIP by internal fixation. Med. Rec, Houston, 1939, 33: 862.— Smith-Petersen, N. M. Treatment of fractures of the neck of the femur by internal fixation. Surg. Gyn. Obst, 1937, 64: 287-95. Also Proc. Interst. Postgrad. M. Ass. N. America, 1938, 372-6.—Sofield, H. A. Fracture of the neck of the femur treated by the steel pin method of fixation. Illinois M. J, 1937 71: 200-4.—Voss, O. Zur Frage der Nagelung des Schenkelhalsbruches. Zbl. Chir, 1937, 64: 686-90.—Zeno, L O. Fractura del cuello del femur; osteosintesis. Rev. med, Rosario, 1933, 23: 762-9.—Zukschwerdt, L, & Reiss. W. Nagelung oder konservative Behandlung des Schenkelhals- bruches? Chirurg, 1936, 8: 477-84. ---- Femoral neck: Fracture: Treatment: Os- teosynthesis: Technic. Brauer, F. *BehandIungsmethoden der Schenkelhalsfraktur mit besonderer Beriicksichti- gung dor Nagelung nach Sven Johansson. 24p. 8? Berl., 1937. Dulot, R. *Traitement des fractures du col du femur par l'enchevillement sans arthrotomie. 42p. 8? Par., 1936. Genty, P. *L'enclouage des fractures recentes du col femoral par voie extra-articulaire " [Paris] 136p. 8? Tours, 1938. Hitsemann, O. *Die Methoden der operativen Knochenbruchvereinigung (Osteosynthese) an der Schenkelhalsfraktur und Mitteilung von drei Fallen von Bolzung bei Pscudarthrose. 27p. fol. Freib. i. B., 1933. Amza Jianu, Firica, T, & Georgesco, P. Le clou de Smith- Petersen dans le traitement des fractures du col femoral. Rev. chir, Bucur, 1938, 41: 485-91.—Asbury, E. Internal fixation of fracture of the neck of the femur without an open operation. Tr. West. Surg. Ass, 1937, 47: 386-403.—AubignS. M. d\ Technique de l'enchevillement des fractures du col du femur par le clou de Smith-Petersen perfore sans arthrotomie. Presse med, 1935, 43: 555-7.—Backer-Grondahl, N. Frac- tures of the neck of the femur: fixation by means of Kirschner wires or by Smith-Petersen nails. Surg. Gyn. Obst, 1937, 64: 1073.—Bader, L, & Gui, L. L'osteosintesi con vite nelle fratture del collo del femore; contributo sperimentale. Chir. org. movim, 1939-40, 25: 321-49.—Eager, B. Zur Technik der Osteosynthese der Schenkelhalsfraktur nach Sven Johans- son. Zbl. Chir, 1933, 60: 1811.—Bloch, R. Une technique simple de visage des fractures du col du femur. Rev. chir. Par, 1930, 68: 105-11.—Bohler, L. Operative Behandlung der Schenkelhalsbi uche mit der extraartikularen Methode von Sven Johansson. Zbl. Chir, 1935, 62: 137-45.—Bosworth, D. M. Concerning the use of Kirschner wire in fractured neck of the femur. IVest, J. Surg, 1936, 44: 484-7.—Breck, L. W. Blind nailing of fractures of the neck of the femur. Southwest. M, 1939, 23: 72-8.—Brittain, H. A. Insertion of the Smith- Petersen nail into the femoral neck. Brit. M. J, 1936 1: 838-40,. pl.—Brocq, P, & Dulot, R. Comment realiser facile- ment et sans erreur possible l'enchi \ illernent des fractures du col du femur sans arthrotomie. Presse med, 1934, 42: 1532.— Brodergen, N. H. [Border's treatment in fracture of the femoral neck] Norsk, mag. laegevid, 1933, 94: (Forh. kirurg. foren.) 22.—Browder, N. C. Nailing the fractured neck of the femur with the aid of the fluoroscope. N. England J. M, 1938, 219: 296-301.—Burns, B. H. Fracture of the neck of the femur, treated by a modification of the Smith-Petersen-pin method. Proc. R. Soc. M, Lond, 1934, 27: Sect. Orth, 581-3.— Carothers, R. G. The technique of internal fixation of fiactures of the neck of the femur. J. Med, Cincin, 1939-40, 20: 00-2 — Carrell, W. B. A report on applicatiomof Smith-Petersen nail in fresh fractures of the femoral neck by adaption of a simplified technic. South. M. J, 1935, 28: 583-8.—Castillo Odena, I. Tecnica de la osteosintesis del cuello del femur. Rev. ortop. traumat, B. Air, 1938-39, 8: 1-52.—Cervenansky, J. Ideales Knochennahtverfahren bei Bruchen des Oberschenkelschaftes. Wien. med. Wschr, 1941, 91: 165-7, 2 pl.—Clcary, E. W, & Morrison, G. M. Lock-bolt fixation of fractures of the femoral neckandof intert i oehanti iic fractures. J. Bone Surg, 1940, 22: 125-30.—Cole, J. P. A blind method of nailing fractured femo- ral necks. Surgery, t939, 6: 841-4.—Conwell, H. E, & Sherrill, J. D. Treatment of recent fractures of the neck of the' femur by Moore nails. J. Tennessee M. Ass, 1938, 31: 172-4 — Cox, W. J. A method of blind pegging fractures of the neck of the femur, using a Smith-Petersen nail or a bone graft as a means of internal fixation. J. Bone Surg, 1936, 18: 134-9.— Dalziel, G. Treatment of fracture of the femoral neck by pinning. Tr. R. Med. Chir. Soc. Glasgow, 1939, 33: 15-20.— Descarpentries. Le teiescopage des fragments dans le traite- ment des fractures du col du femur par vissage double. P. verb. Congr. fr. chir, 1935, 44: 1200-4. -Docley, E. A. Frac- ture of the femoral neck; a rapid and accurate method of inter- nal fixation using a flanged metallic nail. Surg. Gyn. Obst, 1938, 67: 356-62.—Dujarier, C, & Cuvigny. De l'encheville- ment des fractures du col femoral par un greffon peronier modele. Paris chir, 1926, 18: 1-9.—Dussaut, A. Contribu- cion al tratamiento de la fractura de cuello de femur por el clavo de Smith Petersen. Sem. med, B. Air, 1935, 42: pt 2 7 , 7~rDyas',F- -G- & Aries- L- J- Fixation of fractures of neck of femur by introduction of Kirschner wires. Sur<* Gvn Obst 1936, 63: 499-503.-Evensen, H. Zur Osteosynthese des Schenkelhalsbruches. Zbl. Chir, 1941, 68: 386-90.— Exalto, J. [Smith-Petersen- Sven Johansson's method in treat- ment of fractures of the neck of the femurl Ned. tschr. geneesk 1935, 79: 3365-73, 2 pl.-Fenger, M. [Osteosynthesis in tracture of the neck of the femur by Johansson's method] Hospitalstidende, 1935, 78: [Jvdsk. med. selsk. forh ] 104-10 — Fuchsig, P. Zur Technik der Schenkelhalsnagelung. Zbl. Chir, 1937, 64: 1596-9—Gaenslen, F. J. Subcutaneous spike fixation of fresh fractures of the neck of the femur J Bone Surg, 1935, 17: 739-48.—Geckeler, E. O, & Tuttle, A. ' Frac- tures in the neck of the femur; accurate subcutaneous fixation with screws. Surg. Gyn. Obst, 1941, 72: 106-1 l.—Girode, C. Technique de l'enchevillement du col du femur. In Oeuvre scientifique (Delbet, P. L. E.) Par, 1932, 413-7.—Gjessing, collum femoris by Johansson's method] Norsk, mag Iae°-evid ' 1936, 97: [Forh. kir. foren. Oslo] 53-5.—Glissan, D. J. A consideration of certain dimensional factors involved in the internal fixation of the femoral neck. Austral. N. Zealand J Surg, 1940-41, 10: 368-73.—Gold, E. Schenkelhalsnagelung nach der argentinischen Methode (Vails) Zbl. Chir, 1937, 64: 1411-7.—Greer, J. M. Another method of pinning fractures of the neck of the femur. Southwest. M, 1938, 22: 213-5.__■ H abler, C. Technisches zur Nagelung des Schenkelhalsbruches Chirurg, 1938, 10: 449-53. Also Zbl. Chir, 1941, 68: 982-96 — Hartleib, H. Zur Technik der Nagelung bei Schenkelhals- frakturen. Ibid, 1935, 62: 2668-71.—Heidenreich, J. Zur Technik der Schenkelhalsfrakturnagelung nach Sven Johans- son. Ibid, 1937, 64: 148.—Heydemann. Technik der Nage- lung des Schenkelhalsbruches. Beitr. klin. Chir, 1935, 162: 484.—Hillebrand, H. Beitrag zur Behandlung der Schenkel- halsfraktur: femoro-pelvine Verschraubung nach Hotz. Ibid 1933, 157: 266-80.—Hofmann, A. Vereinfachte Rontgen- technik bei der Schenkelhalsnagelung. Zbl. Chir, 1939, 66: 1621-8.—Johansson, S. Zur Technik der Osteosynthese der Fract. colli femoris (vorlaufige Mitteilung) Ibid, 1932, 59: 2019. ------ Noch einmal zur Technik der Osteosynthese der Fract, colli femoris. Ibid, 1933, 60: 864.—Jonas, F. Fracture du col du femur traitee par vissage par la methode de Charbonnier. J. chir, Brux, 1926, 25: 13-21.—Judet, H. Nouvelle technique pour, encheviller les fractures- du col du femur. Paris chir, 1927, 19: 137-42—Jungling, O. Zur Nagelung der Schenkelhalsfraktur. Zbl. Chir, 1938, 65: 226- 33.—Kaplan, A. V. [New technique of operation in fracture of the neck of the femur by means of Smith-Petersen's nail with- out incision] Khirurgia, Moskva, 1938, No. 10. 160-6.—King, D. A simple technique for inserting the Smith-Petersen nail J. Bone Surg, 1938, 20: 501.—King. T. Extraarticular osteo- synthesis for recent fractures of the neck of the femur: a dis- cussion of the technique and a report of personal experiences. Med. J. Australia, 1935, 2: 521-53, 4 pl.—Krauss, F. Zur Technik der Osteosvnthese der Schenkelhalsfraktur nach Sven Johannson. Zbl. Chir, 1933, 60: 799-801.—La Chapelle, E. H, & Justesen, V. [On the deeply driven guiding wire] Ned. tschr. geneesk, 1939, 83: 1897, pl.—La Ferte, A. D. Fractures of the neck of the femur; a technique for rapid nailing; prelimi- nary report, J. Michigan M. Soc, 1941, 40: 531-4.—Lago- marsino, E. H. Tecnica de la artrotomia anteroexterna de la cadera; via de abordaje al segmento femoral de la articulaci6n para facilitar la colocacion del clavo de Smith Petersen a cielo abierto. Rev. ortop. traumat, B. Air, 1935-36, 5: 323-8.— Lascaux, R. Une nouvelle technique de vissage dans les frac- tures du col du femur. Presse med, 1927, 35: 1187-90 — Lehmann, K. [Sven Johansson's method in osteosynthesis in cases of fracture of the collum femoris] Hospitalstidende, 1935, 78: [Dansk. kir. selsk. forh.] 2-13.—Lexer, E. Zur Bolzung von Schenkelhalsbruchen. Deut. med. Wschr, 1926, 52: 1115.— Lichtenauer, K. Zur Technik der Schenkelhalsnagelung. Zb>, Chir, 1938, 65: 635-9.—Lindboe, E. F. Nailing of collum femoris fractures. Acta chir. scand, 1935, 76: 325-44, 20 pl.—■ Linden, O. Percutaneous nailing of fractures of the femoral neck and description of a case where a complication arose during nailing of the neck. Ibid, 1936, 78: 28-32, 3 pl — Lindstrom, L. J. [Extra-articular osteosynthesis in fractures of the colli femoris by Smith-Petersen-Sven Johansson's method] Fin. lak. sail, hand, 1935, 78: 376-93.—Lippmann, R. K. Corkscrew-bolt for compression-fixation of femoral neck fractures. Am. J. Surg, 1937, 37: 79-87.—Littig, L. V. A fluoroscopic technic for nailing fractures of the neck of the femur. Wisconsin M. J, 1939, 38: 373-5.—Masmonteil, F. Double vissage du col du f6mtir k ciel ouvert. P. verb.1 Congr. fr. cir, 1924, 33: 179-83.—Mathieu, P. Technique de l'enclouage des fractures du col du femur. Bull. Acad, med. Par, 1937, 3. ser, 117: 344-8.—Moene, I. [Operative treat- ment of fractures of the neck of the femur by Petensen-.Iohans- son's method] Norsk, mag, laegevid, 1935, 96: 128-97,— 12 pl.—Moore, A. T. Fractures of the neck of the femur; treatment by internal fixation with adjustable nails. South. Surgeon, 1939, 8: 139-47.—Nystrom. G. Multiple nailing of fractura colli femoris. Acta chir. scand, 1940, 84: 279.— O'Meara, J. W. Fractures of the femoral neck treated by blind nailing. Tr. N. England Surg. Soc, 1934, 17: 210-25, pl. Also N. England J. M, 1935, 212: 43-9. Also J. Bone Surg, 1935, 17: 928-32.—Papin, E. Enclouage sous radio- scopie des fractures du col du femur. Rev. orthop. Par, 1939, 3. ser, 26: 248 51.—Paschoud, H. A propos du procede, HIP 666 HIP dc Merle d'Aubigne d'enchevillement du col femoral. Rev. med. Suisse rom., 1938, 58: 371.—Paterson Toledo, R. Algunas modificaciones al aparato de Valls-Lagomaisino para el en- clavijamiento de las fracturas del cuello de femur. Rev. ortop. traumat, B. Air, 1937-38, 7: 150.—Peterson, ('. H. Roentgen technique for the internal fixation of fractures of the femoral neck. Am. J. Roentg, 1936, 35: 226-9.—Picot, G. Radio- graphics de fractures du col femoral enclouees avec lc guide de Hustin et Leemans. Mem. Acad, chir. Par, 1937, 63: 265.— Potts, \V. J. Operative fixation of fracture of the neck of the femur. Illinois M. J, 1940, 77: 133-7.—Richard, M. Die langstreckige (femoro-pelvine) Verschraubung der Schenkel- halsfraktur. Chirurg, 1930, 2: 1027-32.—Roderick, H. B. Fracture of the neck of the femur; another method of insertim: the Smith-Petersen pin. Brit. M. J, 1938, 1: 16. 2 pl.—Ryan. (.. H, & Wheeler, D. The combined surgical and fluoroscopic method of inserting the Smith-Petersen nail. Canad. M. Ass. J, 1940, 43: 231-4.—Schmid, W. Beitrag zur Behandlung der Schenkelhalsfraktur nach Sven Johansson; das Klemmen des Fuhrungsdrahtes; Ursachen und Verhiitung. Deut. Zschr. Chir, 1937, 249: 317-20.— Somb, C. The technique of nailing of fractures of the neck of the femur. Surgerv, 1938, 4: 321-00. Also Chirurg, 1938, 10: 580-92.—Sofleld, H. A. Steel pin fixation for fractures of the neck of the femur. Proc. Inst. M. Chicago, 1938, 12: 102.—Soler, J. El tratamiento de las frac- turas del cuello del femur en aducci6n o coxa vara; el procedi- miento extraarticular de Sven Johansson. Rev. cir. Barcelona, 1935, 10: 213-30.—Sosa, U. Clavo porta-injerto como trata- miento de las fracturas transcervicales y subcapitales del cuello femoral. Arch. Soc. estud. clin. Habana, 1941, 35: 89-98.— Speed, K. Management of fractures of the neck of the femur by operative fixation. Surg. Clin. N. America, 1940, 20: 75- 96.—SteidI, H. Beitrag zur extraartikuliiren Nagelung von Schenkelhalsbruchen. Deut. Zschr. Chir, 1938, 250: 44-51 — Stracker, O. Zur Methodik der Nagelung der Schenkelhals- bruche. Zbl. Chir, 1936, 63: 2060.—Stuyt, J. C. L. M. Me- thode pour assurer la place de la greffe dans les fiactures du col du femur. P. verb. Congr. fr. chir, 1931, 40: 410-3.------ Zur Prioritatsfrage der Drahtfuhrung bei Bohrung von Collum femoris-Frakturen. Zbl. Chir, 1937, 64: 222.—Tavern ier. L. Technique du vissage des fractures recentes du col du f6mur. Rev. techn. chir. Par, 1931, 23: 229-42.—Telson, D. R, & Ransohoff, N. S. Treatment of fractured neck of the femur by axial fixation with steel wires. J. Bone Surg, 1935, 17: 727-38.—Thornton, L, & Sandison, C. Orthopedic problems; fracture of hip (neck of femur) with internal fixation and im- mediate motion of joint. Piedmont Hosp. Bull, 1935-36, 8: 12-23.—Vails, J, & Lagomarsino, E. H. Technique person- nelle et nouvelle instrumentation pour l'osteosynthese du col f6moral k ciel ouvert. Bull. Soc. nat. chir. Par, 1935, 61: 1204-8. Also An. Fac. cienc. med. La Plata, 1937, 1: 405-8 — Van Buuren, N. A. A. A simplified method of introducing the Smith-Petersen pin. Lancet, Lond, 1938, 2: 890. -Van Dyk, C. G. L. The treatment of fracture of the femoral neck by Lippmann's corkscrew bolt. S. Afr. M. J, 1938, 12: 475.— Walker, R. H, jr. The treatment of fractures about the neck of the femur by apposition and compression by use of the Lippmann corkscrew nail. Mil. Surgeon, 1941, 88: 286-90. Also repr.—Wenzl, O. Zur Nagelung des Schenkelhalsbruches. Zbl. Chir, 1937, 64: 1922-7.—Wright, R. D. A technique for osteosynthesis of fractured neck of the femur by the Sinith- Petersen nail. Med. J. Australia, 1934, 1: 518-20.—Zeno, L. O. Fractura del cuello del femur; operaci6n de Smith Petersen. Bol. Soc. cir. B. Aires, 1933, 17: 287-95. Also Rev. cir. B. Aires, 1933, 12: 496-507. Also Rev. med. Rosario, 1933, 23: 428-31. ------ & Marottoli, O. R. Tecnica de la osteosintesis extra- articular del cuello del femur. Rev. ortop. traumat, B. Air 1938-39, 8: 206-11.—Zuelzer, W. Nailing of the fractured neck of the femur without X-ray. South. Surgeon, 1940, 9: 566-70. ---- Femoral neck: Fracture: Treatment: Re- duction, and extension. Boyer, E. *La reduction sanglante suivie d'osteosynthese dans les fractures recentes du col du femur. 135p. 8? Par., 1933. Andrews, R. W. The reduction and artificial impaction of fractures of the neck of the femur. Psychiat. Q, 1928, 2: 364- 9, 4 pl.—Ducroquet, fils. Reduction des fractures du col femoral; leur maintien par les appareils platres. J. chir. Par 1926, 28: 275-95.—Egidi, G. Come semplificare la chiodatura esatta delle fratture di collo femorale. Policlinico, 1937, 44: sez. prat, 1435-7.—Evans, E. M. Well-leg traction apparatus for reducing fractured femoral neck. Lancet, Lond, 1941, 2: 483.—Evans, E. T. The WTiitman abduction internal rotation treatment of fractured neck of the femur. J. Lancet, 1929, 49: 247-9. — 1 inochietto, R. Fractura del cuello del femur: metodo de V human. Prensa med. argent, 1928. 15: 300.—Gaudier, H. Modification a la voie d'acces Petersen-P. Mathieu sur l'articu- lation de la hanche pour la reduction k ciel ouvert et le vissage des fractures du col. Bulk Soc. nat. chir. Par, 1928, 54: 195- 8.—Jones. F. Fractures of the neck of the femur treated by the abduction method as described by Whitman; the report of 2 unusual cases with complete skiagraphic examinations and review of the bibliography. Colorado M, 1925, 22: 389-400 — Jones, S. F, & Sevier, C. E, jr. The abduction treatment of fracture of the neck of the femur as described by Royal Whit- man, M. D. Ibid, 1929, 26: 221.—Kropveld, S. M. [Fracture of femoral neck treated bv Whitman's method] Ned. tschr geneesk, 1926, 70: pt2, 1830.—Kutisker, M. J., & Mulhollnnd! J. H. The reduction of fracture of the neck of the femur witb' Carl P. Jones traction splint. Ann. Surg, 1933, 98: 438-41.- Leadbetter, G. W. Closed reduction of fractures of the neck of the femur. J. Bone Surg, 1938, 20: 108-13.—MacAusland, W. R. Use of the abduction method in the treatment of recent fractures of the neck of the femur. Am. .1. Surg, 1929, n. ser, 6: 798.—McKenna, H. A device for making accurate roentgeno- grams of the neck of the femur during reduction. Sui" Gvn Obst, 194(1. 71: 808-10.—Marangos, G. Verronkuni? iles Schenkelkopfes nach Drahtzug. Zbl. Chir, 1937, 64: 169.— Mills, G. 1*. A modification of Whitman's treatment for frac- ture of the neck of the femur. J. Bone Surg, 1935, 17: 679- S1.—Mumford, E. B. Fracture of the neck of the femur (the importance of correction of the outward rotation of the leg) J. Indiana M. Ass, 1930, 23: 316.—Pfeiffer, D. B. Fractures, of femoral neck treated by the Whitman method. Ann. Surg' 1928, 88:304-6.—Prat, L. La reduction des fractures du col du femur par la methode de translation. (uiz. med. 1'ranee, 1933 206-16.—Rocher, H. L, & Roudil, G. Fracture du col de femur; reduction sous anesthetic locale. J. med. Bordeaux 1933, 110: 126.—Schramm, H. G. Die Technik der Whh> manschen Behandlung der Schenkelhalsbriiche. Chirurg, 1928-29, 1: 793-6.—Serra, A. La riduzione incrucnta delle fratture recenti del collo del femore col metodo della adduziono forzata. Boll. Poliamb. Giuseppe Ronzoni, 1933, 7: 209-32.— Snodgrass. L. E. Fractures of the neck of the femur; method for reduction and fixation by adduction. Am. J. Surg, 1935, 27: 487-98. Also repr.—Thomas, A. Fractures of the neck of the femur; Whitman abduction treatment. Colorado M, 1935, 32: 188-92.— Whitman, R. Remarks introductory to a demonstration of the abduction treatment of fracture of the neck of the femur. J. Bone Surg, 1930, 12: 11-4. -----. The abduction treatment for fracture of the neck of the femur. Acta chir. scand, 1930, 67: 952-6. Also Surg. Clin. N. America, 1931, 11: 583-92. Also Med. Press & Circ, Dub, 1935, 191: Suppl, p. ix-xiv. ------ The abduction method: considered as the exponent of surgical principles in the routine treatment of fracture of the neck of the femur. Brit. M. J, 1936, 2: 167- 9.—Willems, C. Mes directives actuelles dans le traitement des fractures du col; pour l'extension continue, l'abduction est inutile. P. verb. Congr. fr. chir, 1924, 33: 141-4.—Winter- stein, O. Die Anwendung der Lokalanasthesie fiir die Reposi- tion der Fractura colli femoris. Chirurg, 1930, 2: 704-8. ---- Femoral neck: Fracture: Treatment: Re- sults. Gressler, M. *Die Ergebnisse der Behand- lung von Oberschenkelbriichen in den Jahren 1920 bis 1929, in der chirurgischen Universitats- klinik. 114p. 8? Berl., 1936. Holscher, G. *Heilungsergebnis.se> der trau- matischen Obersohenkelfrakturen dargestellt an 110 in den Jahren 1919-28 in der Kiclcr chirur- gischen Universitatsklinik behandelten und 1930 nachuntersuchten Fallen [Kiel] 16p. 8? Rost., 1932. Koleff, D. *Ergebnisse der Behandlung der Schenkelhalsfrakturen an der Rostocker chirur- gischen Universitatsklinik in den Jahren 1922-26. 47p. 8? [Rostock] 1927. Mindus, W. *Erfahrungen bei der Behand- lung von Schenkelhalsbruchen [Frankfurt] 24p. 8? Berl., 1936. Schtjlte-Probsting, E. *Ergebnisse der Be- handlung von Schenkelhalsfrakturen; iiber 17 Falle der chirurgischen Universitatsklinik zu Munster in Westfalen [Munster] 29p. 20^cm. Quakenbruck, 1935. Auvray. Resultats 61oignes des fiactures du col du femur. Bull. Soc. nat. chir. Par, 1933, 59: 912-6. —--- Resultats eioignes des fractures du femur t rai tees par le vissage a ciel ouvert. P. verb. Congr. fr. chir, 1924, 33: 183-6.—Brandt, R. Erfahrung der chirurgischen Klinik Kiel mit der Schenkel- halsnagelung. Arch. klin. Chir, 1939, 195: 626-45.—Broom- head, R. Four cases of high fracture of the neck of the femur, treated by the use of a Smith-Petersen pin. Proc. R. Soc. M, Lond, 1933, 26: Sect. Orth, 1327-30.—Buchheim, W. Erfahrungen fiber die Bolzung von 27 Oberecheiikelhalfl- bruchen. Deut. Zschr. Chir, 1935-36, 246: 439-48.—Camp- bell, W. C, Conwell, H. E. [et al.] Treatment of fractures of the neck of the femur by internal fixation; report of the Frac- ture Committee of the American Academy of Orthopaedic Surgeons. J. Bone Surg, 1941, 23: 386-90.—Carothers, R. G. Internal fixation of fractures of the neck of the femur; au analysis of results. Tr. South. Surg. Ass, 1937, 50: 401-8 [Discussion] 418. Also Ann. Surg, 1938, 107: 980-7.—Cleve- land, M. A critical survey of 10 years' experience with frac- tures of the neck of the femur. Surg. Gyn. Obst, 1942, 74: 529-40.—Creyssel, J. A propos du resultat lointain dans le HIP 667 HIP traitement des fractures du col du femur. Lyon chir, 1939-40, 36: 688.—Ettorre, E. Die Endergebnisse von 308 im Ospedale Maggiore in Mailand behandelten Schenkelhalsbruchen. Verh. Deut. orthop. Ges. (1932) 1933, 27. Kongr, 60-76.—Felsen- reich, F. Ueber die Ursachen der Misserfolge nach Schenkel- halsbruchoperationen. Zbl. Chir, 1936, 63: 2257-9.------ Histologische Untersuchungen an operierten Schenkelhals- bruchen; die Perforation von Hals und Kopf durch den stflh- lernen Bolzen. Arch. klin. Chir, 1939, 195: 30-61,------ Die Veranderungen an der Hiiftpfanne nach Perforation des HUftkopfcs durch den stahlernen Bolzen. Ibid, 589-610. ----- Die Rolle des 3-Lamellennagels als Fremdkorper. Ibid, 1938-39, 194: 584-620.—Ferey, D. A propos de 7 observations de vissage de fractures du col du femur. Bull. med. Par, 1933, 47: 355-7. Also Bull. Soc. nat. chir. Par, 1933, 59: 257-60.—Fuchsig, P. Ergebnisse der konservativen Behandlung von Schenkelhalsbruchen. Chirurg, 1937, 9: 926-30.—Groves, E. W. Treatment of fractured neck of the femur with especial regard to the results. J. Bone Surg, 1930, 12: 1-11. ----— Modern treatment and results of treatment of fractures of the neck of the femur. Brit. M. J, 1937, 2: 359-61.—Gruca, A. [Five years of experience in treatment of fresh fractures of the neck of the femur by sub- cutaneous osteosynthesis] Chir. narz. ruchu, 1936, 9: 403-38.— Hansson, H. E, & Hellgren, E. G. Some experiences with treatment of collum femoris fractures by Sven Johansson's method. Acta orthop. scand, 1935, 6: 77-91.—Harris, R. I. Experiences with internal fixation in fresh fractures of the neck of the femur. J. Bone Surg, 1938, 20: 114-23.—Hoets, J. Fracture of the neck of the femur; pros and cons of nailing. Austral. N. Zealand J. Surg, 1940-41, 10: 278-81.—Hoffheinz. Meine Erfahrungen mit der Nagelung frischer Schenkelhals- frakturen. Arch. klin. Chir, 1938, 193: 658-64 [Discussion] 178.—Inclan, A. Consideraciones sobre resultados y estadistica. Cir. ortop. traumat, Habana, 1940, 8: 145-7.—Janik, A. [Results of operative treatment of fracture of the neck of the femur] Chir. narz. ruchu, 1936, 9: 107-14.—Jerusalem, M. Rontgenschadigung nach Osteosynthese des Schcnkelhalses. Zbl. Chir, 1936, 63: 2439-41.—Johansson, S. Afterexamina- tion of collum fractures of the femur operated on by extra- articular osteosynthesis. Acta orthop. scand, 1934, 5: 118-24. ----- Operative treatment and results in fracture of neck of femur. Brit. M. J, 1937, 2: 361-3.—Krabbel, M. Ergebnisse der Behandlung des Schenkelhalsbruches. Mschr. Unfallh, 1932, 39: 151-7.—Krenn, L. Autoptischer Befund nach genagelter, geheilter Schenkelhalsfraktur. Zbl. Chir, 1938, 65: 1075.—Kuntscher, G. Ergebnisse von 77 Schenkelhals- nagelungen der Kieler Klinik. Ibid, 1939, 66: 875-82. Ergebnisse und Indikation der Schenkelhalsnagelung. Arch. orthop. UnfaUchir, 1939-40, 40: 282-4—LeCocq, E. End- results of nailing fractures of neck of femur. Northwest M, 1939, 38: 141.—Lehmann, K. Results of treatment of medical collum femoris fractures, "with special reference to osteo- synthesis ad mod. Sven Johansson; studie on the importance of the fracture form for consolidation. Acta chir. scand, 1935, 77: 271-95, 6 pl.—Leveuf, J. Resultat de traitement des fractures du col du femur par la methode du Professeur Delbet. P. verb. Congr. fr. chir, 1924, 33: 207-13—Leydig, S. M. Fractures of neck of the femur treated with Smith-Petersen nail; analysis of 78 cases during 1937. Surg. Gyn. Obst, 1939, 68: 713-7.—Lippmann, R. K. Experiences with the corkscrew bolt. J. Bone Surg, 1939, 21: 735-46—Lftfberg, O. Be- handlung der Fractura colli femoris. Zbl. Chir, 1927, 54: 2222-35.—Masmonteil, F. Indications, technique et resultats du vissage dans les fractures du col du femur. Bull. Soc. chir. Paris, 1933, 25: 503-12.—Moore, A. T, & Green, J. T. Frac- tures of the neck of the femur; treated by internal fixation with adjustable nails; end result studies. South. Surgeon, 1940, 9: 684-9.—Nystrom, G. Some experiences with the treatment of fractura colli femoris medialis by the pegging method of Smith- Petersen, Sven Johansson. Acta chir. scand, 1935, 76: 1-24.— Osten, W. Erfahrungen mit der Schenkelhalsnagelung nach Smith Petersen. Beitr. klin. Chir, 1935, 162: 31-9.—Patel, M. Resultats anatomiques et cliniques du traitement des fractures du col femoral par le vissage. P. verb. Congr. fr. chir, 1923, 32: 739-43.—Prat. Traitement des fractures du col du femur; resultats. Ibid, 1924, 33: 187-206.—Reggio, A. W. Fractures of the femoral neck; an end-result study of non-operative treatment. J. Bone Surg, 1930, 12: 819-20—Rowlette, A, Haslem, J. R. [et al.] Results obtained by subcutaneous pinning of fractures through neck of femur. J. Am. M. Ass, 1936, 107: 1610-4.—Ruiz Moreno. Resultado alejado de un enclavi- jamiento por fractura del cuello del femur. Bol. Soc. cir. B. Aires. 1928, 12: 251-60.—Schmid, W. Misserfolge bei der extraartikularen Osteosynthese der Schenkelhalsfraktur. Chi- rurg, 1937, 9: 419-25.—Schnek, F. Ergebnisse der Behandlung von Schenkelhalsfrakturen mittels Nagelung. Wien. med. Wschr, 1935, 85: 1368.—Schumann, G. Spatcrgebnisse und Spatschaden der Schenkelhalsbolzung- Beitr. klin. Chir, 1939, 170: 567-80.—Selig, S. Objections to the use of Kirsch- ner wire for fixation of femoral-neck fractures. J. Bone Surg, 1939, 21: 182-6.—Smith-Petersen. M. N. Treatment of fractures of the neck of the femur by internal fixation; report of the fracture committee of the American Academy of Ortho- paedic Surgeons. Ibid, 483-6.—Speed, K. Fracture of the neck of the femur; cUnical criteria in prognosis. Tr. Am. Surg. Ass, 1932, 50: 334-43. Also Ann. Surg, 1932, 96: 951-9 — Stocker, H. Erfahrungen mit der extraartikularen Osteo- synthese der Schenkelhalsbriiche. Chirurg, 1935, 7: 881-6.— Thomas, A Sevier, C. E, & Matchett, F. Treatment of fractures of the neck of the femur by internal fixation, blind ??q o£; a ^eV.ew ?f 37 cases- Rocky Mountain M. J, 1941, 38- .18-20.—Vails, J, & Lagomarsino. E. H. Resultados de la osteosintesis en las fracturas del cuello femoral. Relat. Congr argent cir. (1936) 1937, 8. Congr, l006-9.-Van Ravenswafy! A. Steel pin inserted into neck of femur found in bladder Am. J. Surg, 1936, 31: 566.—Viannay. Mauvais resultat eloigne dun cas de vissage d'une fracture du col du femur Loire med, 1925, 39: 341-6.—Westcott, H. H. End-results aitcr internal fixation of transcervical fractures of the femur Virginia M. Month, 1935-36, 62: 446-8.—Wheat, H R Report of 17 consecutive cases of fracture of the femoral neck treated by internal fixation. N. England J. M. 1937 217- 97-9.—Wilson, J. C. Fracture of the neck of the femur; end results in 86 cases. CaUfornia West. M, 1930 33- 707-11__ Wustmann & Albrecht, H. Ueber Behandlungsergebnisse bei Schenkelhalsbruchen. Deut. Zschr. Chir, 1931, 231: 516-21. ---- Femoral neck: Fracture, ununited. See also Hip-joint, Pseudoarthrosis. Soholl, O. *Die operative Behandlung nicht konsolidierter Schenkelhalsfrakturen. 34p 8° Berl., 1919. Albee, F. H. Ununited fracture of the neck of the femur. Internat. Chn, 1928, 38. ser, 2: 222-4, 2 pl. ------ Late end result* in ununited fracture of the neck of the femur treated by the peg or the reconstruction operation. J. Bone Surg, 1928,10:124-43.------Physiotherapv in ununited fracture of the neck of the femur. Internat. J. M. & S, 1929, 42: 459. ------ Treatment of ununited fracture of the neck of the femur. Proc. Panpacific Surg. Conf, 1929, 1. Conf, 403-9 Also Surg. Gyn. Obst, 1929, 49: 810-7. ------ AppUeation of the bone-graft peg in ununited fracture of the neck of the femur. Surg. Clin. N. America, 1929, 10: 619-34.—Alldredge, R. H. Reconstruction operations for fracture of the neck of the femur with non-union. N. Orleans M. & S. J, 1940-41, 93: 201-8.—Anschutz, W, & Portwich, O. Prognose und Therapie der veralteten Schenkelhalsfraktur. Erg. Chir. Orthop, 1927 20: 1770.—Bickel, W. H, & Ghormley, R. K. Brackett operation for ununited fractures of the neck of the femur; report of 2 cases. Proc. Mayo CUn, 1941, 16: 345-8.— Blount, W. P. The blade-plate internal fixation of high osteo- tomy in ununited fracture of the femoral neck. Proc. Inst. M. Chicago, 1942-43, 14: 156.—Brackett, E. G. Reconstruc- tion operations for old ununited fractures of the neck of the femur. J. Bone Surg, 1938, 20: 93-6.—Braitzev, V. R. [Plastic method in surgical treatment of ununited fractures of neck of femur] Russ. klin, 1927, 7: No. 36, 654-8.—Campbell, W. C. Surgical procedures for ununited fractures of the neck of the femur. Internat. Clin, 1938, n. ser, 1: 34-43, 8 pl. ------ Ununited fracture of the neck of the femur. Surgery, 1937, 1: 499-516. Also Surg. Gyn. Obst, 1939, 69: 697-9.------ & Smith, H. Treatment of ununited fractures of the neck of the femur. Southwest. M, 1941, 25: 70-3.—Christopher, F. Smith-Petersen operation for ununited fracture of the neck of the femur. Surg. CUn. N. America, 1935, 15: 601-4.—Colonna. P. C. A new type of reconstruction operation for old ununited fracture of the neck of the femur. J. Bone Surg, 1935, 17: 110-22. —----■ The problem of old ununited fracture of the neck of the femur. Yearb. N. York & N. England Ass. Railw. Surg, 1935, 45: 54-8. ------ The problem of non- union in fracture of the neck of the femur. Virginia M. Month, 1937-38, 64: 77-81, 4 figs. ------ A reconstruction operation for old ununited fracture of the femoral neck. J. Bone Surg, 1937, 19: 945-54. Also J. Oklahoma M. Ass, 1938, 31: 266-8. The Colonna reconstruction operation for ununited fractures of the neck of the femur; analysis of 70 cases. J. Bone Surg, 1939, 21: 701-9. ■------ Treatment of ununited fracture of the neck of the femur. South. M. J, 1939, 32: 65-7.—Dickson, J. A. Treatment of ununited fractures of the neck of the femur; report of 2 cases. Cleveland Clin. Q, 1938, 5: 295-9. ------ Treatment of ununited fractures of the neck of the femur by means of bone graft and Smith-Petersen nail. Surg. Clin. N. America, 1939, 19: 1235-41.—Freiberg, A. H. Ununited fracture of the neck of the femur. J. Med, Cincin, 1927-28, 8: 235-8.—Galland, W. I. Ununited frac- tures of the neck of the femur; treatment bv the bifurcation operation. Am. J. Surg, 1935, 30: 410-9.—Gallic, W- E„ & Lewis, F. I. Ununited fracture of the neck of the femur in the aged. J. Bone Surg, 1940, 22: 76-80.—George, A. W, & Leonard, R. D. Ununited intracapsular fractures of the femoral neck roentgenographically considered. Am. J. Roentg, 1934, 31: 433-41.—Gill, A. B. Arthrodesis for ununited fracture of the neck of the femur. J. Bone Surg, 1939, 21: 710-4.— Hamsa, W. R. The treatment of femoral neck non-union. Nebraska M. J, 1938, 23: 455-61.------ Intracapsular femoral neck non-union. Surg. Gyn. Obst, 1939, 69: 200-5.—■ Henderson, M. S. Fractures of the neck of the femur, with special reference to nonunion. Internat. J. M. & S, 1929, 42: 423-8. ------ Ununited fractures of the neck of the femur. Tr. West. Surg. Ass, 1934, 44: 32&-45. Also West. J. Surg, 1935, 43: 134-42. ------ Bone graft in ununited fractures of the neck of the femur. Proc. Inst. M^Chicago, 1938, 12: 200. ------ Present-day treatment of ununited fractures of the neck of the femur. Minnesota M, 1940, 23: 339-43. Also J. Bone Surg, 1940, 22: 97-106.—Hermann, O. J. Re- HIP 668 HIP constructions in non-united femoral neck fractures. Surg. Gyn. Obst, 1940, 70: 403-7- Hirkey, P. M. The roent- genologic demonstration of non-union in the femoral neck. Am. J. Roentg, 192S. n. ser, 20: 14-7. Inclan, A. Nueslra nctitud frente a lo- trastornos de consolidaci6n en las fracturas del cuello del femur. Cir. ortop. traumat.. Habana, 1937, 5: 234-49.—Johnson, P. E. The Schanz osteotomy for ununited fractures of the neck of the femur. Med. Hull. Veterans Admin, 1938-39, 15: 3-5.—Karfiol, G. J. I'auwels' reclination, a phvsiological reconstruction for non-united fracture of the neck of the femur. Surg. Gyn. Obst, 1939, 68: 648-57 — Kienbock, R, A- Selka, A. Inaktivitiitssvnostose von Sehenkel- kopf und lluftpfanne bei nicht geheiltem Schenkelhalsbruch. Rontgenpraxis, 1935. 7: 214.—Macey. H. B. Ununited fracture of the neck of the femur treated by bone graft. Proc. Mayo Clin, 1934, 9: 582-4. ------ Reconstruction operation for ununited fracture of the neck of the femur: report of case. Ibid, 1935, 10: 676-8. ------ & Cameron. D. IM. Unusual complication following Colonna reconstruction operation for ununited fracture of the neck cf the femur; report of case. Ibid, 1939, 14: 728— McMurray, T. P. Ununited fractures of the neck of the femur. J. Bone Surg, 1936, 18: 319-27.— Magnuson, P. B. The repair of ununited fracture of the neck of the femur. J. Am. M. Ass, 1932, 98: 1791-4. Also repr. ------ Report of 59 consecutive cases of un-united fracture of the neck of the femur. Surgery, 1940, 7: 763-72.—Malkin, S. A. S. Union of an ununited fracture of the neck of the femur following a trochanteric o.-tootoniv. Proc. R. Soc. M, Lond, 1934-35, 28: 641.—Miltner, I, J. An operation for ununited fracture of the neck of the femur. J. Iowa M. Soc, 1940, 30: 9-11.- Nutter, J. A. Intertrochanteric osteotomy for nonunion of fracture of the neck of the femur. Am. j. Surg, 1942, 55: 432.—Phemister, 1>. B. The pathology of ununited fractures of the neck of the femur with special refer- ence to the head. J. Bone Surg, 1939, 21: 681-93. - Pollock, G. A. Pathologic and related changes which occur in the head of the femur following ununited fracture of the neck. Proc. Mayo Clin, 1939, 14: 083-5. Powers, J. W. An evaluation of the modem treatment of ununited fiactures of the neck of the femur. Wisconsin M. J, 1932. 31: 512-4.—Reich, R. S. Ununited fracture of the neck of the femur treated bv high oblique osteotomy. J. Bone Surg, 1941, 23: 141-58.—Selig, S. Spontaneous shelf formation in ununited fracture of the neck of the femur. Ibid, 1935, 17: 792.—Sherrill, J. D. Ununited fracture of the neck of the femur. J. M. Ass. Alabama, 1933, 3: 204.—Simpson, W. C, & Henderson, M. S. Lag screw fixation in ununited fracture of neck of femur: report of ease. Proc. Mayo Clin.. 1930, II : 573-6.—Speed. J. S, & Smith, II. Trochanteric osteotomy !'oi ununited fiactures of the neck of the femur. South. M. J, 1911. 31: 798-SOC..-Speed, K. I'nuniting fracture of the neck of the femur. Tr. West. Surg. Ass.. 1928. 38: 29 44. Also Suig. Clin. N. America, 1929, 9: 273-92.—Spitzy. Endergebnisse des Rekonstruktionsver- lahrens bei nicht geheilten Schenkelhalsbruchen. Verh. Deut. orthop. Ges. (1932) 1933, 27. Kongr, 53-60.—Ussachev, V. A. [On the treatment of ununited fractures of the neck of the femur] Med. misl, Rostov, 192.5-26, 3: 15-8. Whitman. R. The operative treatment of ununited fracture of the neck of the femur. Surg. Gyn. Obst, 1930, 50: 885-7.—Wolcott, W. E. Circulation of the head and neck of the femur; its relation to nonunion in fractures of the femoral neck. J. Am. M. Ass, 1933, 100: 27-34. ---- Femoral neck: Fracture—in the aged. Doxath, L. II. *Treatment of fractures of the neck of the femur in the aged by a particular method of skin traction. 22p. 4? S. Franc, 1933. Bankart, A. S. B. Union and non-union of fractures; with special reference to fractures of the neck of the femur in elderlv people. Brit. M. J, 1930, 1: 8-10, pl.—Cannaday, J. E. Treatment of fracture of the neck of the femur in the aged. Ann. Surg, 1930, 91: 750-2.—De Las Casas. H. IndividuaUza- tion of the treatment of fracture of the neck of the femur in the aged. J. Internat. Coll. Surgeons, 1939, 2: 409-12.— Judet, H. Un nouveau cas de fracture intracapsulaire du col du femur chez un vieillard consolide osseusement par I'appareil platre. P. verb. Congr. fr. chir, 1923, 32: 733-8.—Refer. N. I. [Causes_of frequent fractures of the neck of the femur in old age] Ortop. travmat, 1935, 9: 15.—Leveuf, J. A propos du traitement des fractures transcervicales du col du f6mur Bull. Soc. nat. chir. Par, 1929, 55: 380-4.—McBride, E. D. Fracture of the neck of the femur in the aged. J. Oklahoma M. Ass, 1931, 24: 15.--Malattie (Le) della vecchiaja; frattura del coUo del femore. Progr. ter., Milano, 1903, 193.—Mathias, J. P. Treatment of fractures of tin hi]mo the aged. Internat J. M. & S, 1931, 44: 136-8.—Moriel, E. A propos du traite- ment des fractures du col femoial chez le vieillard par I'appareil 1.1'it re de Whitman. P. verb, Congr. fr. chir, 1925, 34: >'M-.>.-- Murra\. D. A. Fractures of the neck of the femur in the aged. W.-t. J. Surg, 1932, 40: 451-3.—Niederecker, K. Behandlung der Schenkelhalsfrakturen des Femur bei iilteren Personen. Verh. uiigar. arztl. Ges, 1936, 8: 5.—Pascalis, M. Traitement partici^i r k certaines fractures du col femoral chez le vieillard. Bull. .-oc. med. Paris, 1938, 698.—Vereshchakov- sky. I. I. [Technique in the tieatment of fractures of the neck of the femur in aged people: control of outward rotation of the foot] Ortop. travmat. 1939, 13: No. 3, 39. ---- Femoral neck: Fracture—in animals. Cliza, S, & Ciurea, V. [Fracture of the coxa in the horse] Rev. vet. mil, liueur, 1939, 10: 15-21. Diincmann. Intra- kapsulare Femui halsfi.iktur beim I'ferde. Z-chr. Veteriniirk, 1939, 51: 170-5. -Iviigman. II. K. Piacture of the neck of femur and acetabulum. North Am. Vet, 1939, 20: No 0 47-9. Also Yet. Pract, Evanston, 1939, 20: No. 10, 18-22. ' ---- Femoral neck: Fracture—in the child. Colonna, P. C. Fracture of the neck of the femur in children Am. J. Surg, 1929, n. ser, 6: 793-7.------Fracture of the neck of the femur in childhood; a report of 6 cases. Ann. Surg. 1928, 88: 902-19- Cimtantini. Enclouago du col du f6mur pour fracture transect vienlo chez un enfant de It ans. AlgSrie med, 1940, 4. ser.. 44: I 1(1. -Delbet. Fracture du col du femur chez un jeune homme de 15 aus. Rev. gen. dm. ther 1920, 40: 720-8.—Fractures in the neck of the femur in children' Am. J. Roentg, 1912, 47: 102.— Jehn. W. Kindlifihe Schenkel- halsfraktur. Beitr. klin. Chir.. 1938. 167: 447. -Koch. V. Epiphysenschiidigung bei Nagclexlension im kindlichen Alter. Zschr. orthop. Chir, 1929, 52: 89-95.—Lindsay, E. A. Fracture of the neck of the femur in a girl of 12 years. Proc. R. Hoc M, Lond, 1928-29, 22: Sect. Orthop, 18 -20.- Mitchell. J. I. Fracture of the neck of the femur in children. J. Am. M. Ass 1930, 107: 1603-6.—Schmid, W. Zur Behandlung der Oher- schenkelschaftfraktur des Kindes; Vorbediugungon; To.-hnik Arch. klin. Chir, 1934, 170: 537-50—Vengerjvsky, I. S. [Fractures of the neck of the femur in children] Khirurgia, Moskva, 1938, No. 5, 114-21, pl.—Wilson, J. C. Fractures of the nock of the femur in childhood. J. Bone Surg, 1910, 22: 531 -46.—Zur Verth, M. Sekundare Nek rose de.s Schenkel- kopfes nach SchenkelhaLsbriiclien Jugcndlicher. Zbl. Chir, 1935, 62: 2549-57. ---- Femoral neck: Malacia. Kienbock, R. Ueber juvenile Schenkelhalsmalazie hypo- phy.-.arcn Urs|iruugs. Zschr. orthop. Chir, 1932, 57: 408. ---.— Uebei- Schenkelhalsmalazie bei kombinii'i ler Ilypn- physen- und Seliilddriisenentartung. Strahleufherapie, 1937, 60: 1 15-9.— Komz-.t, J. [On malacia of the neck of the femur in childien (Kienbock)] Chir. narz. ruchu, 1935, 8: 181-6, pl.— Mauclaire. Lea inflexions de la tete et du col f6moral avec ou sans osteoporose; les coxa hyperflecta. Mem. Acad, chir. Par, 1938, 64: 470-80.—Springer. K. Aseptischer Schenkel- halsnekrose. Klin. Wschr, 1940, 19: 999 (microfilm) ---- Femoral neck: Tumor. Broc & Maruani. Fracture spontanee par stwoome primitif du col de femur. Gaz. med. Fiance, 1937, 44: radiol, 261.— Fayard & Surrel. Radiographic d'un kyste du col du femur gauche. Loire med.. 1931, 45: 130.- Henderson, M. S. Giant-cell tumor of the upper end of the femur; report of 3 cases. Minnesota M.. 1928, 11: 542-7.- Martin, J. F, De- chaume, J, & Levrat, M. i'lasmoci tome du col femoral. Bull. Ass. fr. cancer, 1928. 17: 537-48.—Sonntag. Schenkel- halsosteofibrom. Zbl. Chn., 1925. 52: 1.8K0 2. Trinchera, C. Considerazioni su di un caso di formazione cistica del collo femorale complicata a frattura. Policlinico, 1933, 40: s"z. prat, 650-3.—Turner, W. G. Giant-celled tumour of the neck of the femur; operation with ptobable cure. Canad. M. Ass. J, 1928, 19: 342-5. ---- Fracture. See also other subheadings; also Pelvis, Frac- ture. Allen, E. S. The fractured hip. Kentucky M. J, 1940, 38: 293-8.—Aquino. T. Una strana lesione dell'anca riportata da una donna in puerperio. Rinasc. med, 1935, 12: 104.—Colvin, A. R. Fractures of the hip. Minnesota M, 1931, 14: 960-2 — Cotton, F. J. Some new items as to hip fractures. Boston M. & S. J, 1925, 192: 1212-4. ------• Intracapsular hip fracture. J. Bone Surg, 1934, 16: 105-9. ---— & Morrison, G. M. Hip fractures; valgus position—accidental or engineered. Ibid. 1938, 20: 461-8.—Doolin, W. Fractured hips: snags and pit- falls. Irish J. M. Sc, 1935, 6. ser, 152-67, 4 pl.- Engel, G. C. Fractures about the hip. Surg. Clin. N. America, 1940, 20: 1721-41.—Frescoln, L. D. Observations on fractured hips. Med. Rec, N. Y, 1911, 153:96.- Glock, W. R. Hip fractures. J. Indiana M. Ass, 1939, 32: 353 6.- -Gordon, T. E. Intra- capsular fractures at tin- hip. hibh J. M. Sc, 1927. 6. ser, 212-4.—Hancock, J. C. Fract u,e of the hip. .1. Iowa M. Soc, 1928, 18: 267-71.— Hart, V. L. Impacted fracture of the hip. Surgery, 1942, 11: 472. -Henderson, M. S. Fracture of the hip. Proc. Mayo Clin., 1928. 3: 373, ----— Intracapsular fracture of the hip. Siirg. < lin. N. America, 1930, 10: 33-5.— Hendon, G. A. Fracture of the hip in the aged. N. Orleans M. & S. J, 1934, 86: 619. Also Tr. South. Surg. Ass., 1935, 48: 428-38. Also Mississippi Doctor, 1936-37, 14: No. 3, 18-23.- Howard, L. G, & Christophe, K. Intracapsular fracture of the hip; report of 100 consecutive cases. J. Am. M. Ass, 1934. 103: 1833-6.—Jackson, J. A, & Sisk, J. N. Hip injuries; solulion of the unsolved fracture. Am. J. Surg, 1939, 45: 48-52.-- Knowles, V. I, Fractures of the hip. J. Iowa M. Soc-, 1931, 21: 547-9.—Kreuscher, P. H. Fractures of the hip. Internat. J. M. & S, 1935, 48: 139 17 — Mabry, C. B. Some observa- HIP 669 HIP tions on fractures of the hip. J. Florida M. Ass, 1938-39, 25: 334-6 —Malpractice; mistake in diagnosis of fracture of hip. J Am. M. Ass, 1937, 108: 1296.—Malpractice; failure to discover fracture of hip [U. S. Circuit Court] Ibid, 1938, 111: 1045—Malpractice; negUgence in diagnosis of hip fracture [U. S. District Court] Ibid, 1939, 113: 1990.—Masland, H. C. Stumble fractures of the hip in the aged. Internat. J. M. & S, 1932 45: 78-82.—Milch, H. On the use of N61aton's line. Med. Rec, N. Y, 1938, 147: 229.—Moorhead, J. J. The problem of the broken hip. N. York State J. M, 1936, 36: 796-800.—Mumford, E. B. Fracture of the hip. J. Indiana M. Ass, 1933, 26: 305-11.—Ochsner, E. H, & Sullivan, J. K. Recent fractures of the hip. Tr. South. Surg. Ass. (1929) 1930, 42: 175-85, 2 pl. Also Internat. J. M. & S, 1929, 42: 620-6.—O'Donoghue, A. F. Fractures of the hip. J. Iowa M. Soc , 1939, 29: 152-6.—O'Ferrall, J. T. Fracture of the hip in adults. Med. J. & Rec, 1926, 124: 260-4. Also repr — Reggio, A. W, & Wilson, P. D. Fractures in the region of the hip In Experience Managem. Fractures (Wilson, P. D.) Phila, 1938, 815-91.—Ruth, C. E, & Ruth, V. A. Fractures of the hip. J. Am. M. Ass, 1930, 94: 169-74. Also repr — Rutkevich, N. L. [Gun-shot fractures of the hip] Sovet. med, 1940, 4: No. 20, 20.—Thiery, P. A propos des fractures avec enfoncement du cotyle. Bull. Soc. nat. chir. Par, 1929, 55: 42.—Todd, M. H. Fractures of the hip. Virginia M. Month, 1936-37, 63: 353-5.—Wilson, G. F. P. Fractures of the upper end of the femur. Univ. Toronto M. J, 1939-40, "17: 280-4. ---- Fracture: Treatment. Aden, M. The physical therapy after-care of the fractured hip; treatment based on 8 cases where the Austin Moore pins had been employed for internal fixation. Physiother. Rev, 1940, 20: 262-7.—Barber, J. D. Melbourne skin extension. Nurs. Times, Lond, 1941, 37: 951.—Bogoraz, N. A. [Extra- articular extension of the hip-bone] Ortop. travmat, 1932, 6: 19-23.—Brewster, W. R. Internal fixation in fractures of the hip (Martin method) Am. J. Surg.. 1935, 30: 420-6.—Brookes, T. P. Fractured hips in the aged: improved prognosis with the use of physical therapy. Week. Bull. S. Louis M. Soc. 1938-39, 33: 108.------& Ewerhardt, F. H. Fractured hips in the aged; improved prognosis through physical therapv. Arch. Phys. Ther, 1939, 20: 29-34.—Bush. I, F. The treatment of fractures of the hip. Pennsylvania M. J, 1938-39, 42: 1325- 9. Also repr.—Caldwell, G. A, & Oxford, T. M. Fractures of the hip; fixation with nails introduced under X-ray control. Tri- state M. J, 1937-38, 10: 2078.—Chester, J. B. Hip fractures; treatment by the multiple Kirschner wire method. Surg. Gyn. Obst, 1941, 73: 702-10.—Conley, G. J. Fracture of hip in the aged with nail fixation; a contrast of early and modern methods. College J.; Kansas City, 1942. 26: 8-11.—Cornell, N. W. Internal fixation of fractures of hip bv Austin Moore pins. Physiother. Rev, 1940, 20: 261.— Cotton, F. J. Artificial impaction in hip fractures. Surg. Gyn. Obst, 1927, 45: 307- 19. ------ Operative treatment of hip fractures; intracap- sular. Am. J. Surg, 1937, 38: 619-28.—DuBose, F. G. Frac- ture of the hip: open operation under local anesthesia. Internat. J. Surg, 1928, 41: 585-8.—Elliott, J. R. Treatment of hip fractures. Clin. Med, 1941, 48: 302.—Ferciot, C. F. A simpli- fied directional guide for hip nailing. J. Bone Surg, 1939, 21: 1023-6.—Freeman, G. W. Fractures of the hip joint; extra- articular fixation with a single screw. Northwest M, 1939, 38: 46-51.—Geckeler, E. O. Subcutaneous fixation with screws for fractures of the hip. Am. J. Surg, 1937, 37: 396-402 — George, A. W. Shortening the period of disability in fractures of the hip, intracapsular type. Bull. U. S. Dep. Lab. Div. Lab. Standards, 1935, 2: 154-9.—Hawley, J. E. Hip splint. U. S. Patent Off, 1936, No. 2,044,299.—Henderson, M. S. Recent fracture of the hip: Smith-Petersen nail inserted over a Kirsch- ner wire. Proc. Mayo CUn, 1934, 9: 203-5.—Hendon, G. A. The treatment for fracture of the hip. Tr. South. Surg. Ass, 1927, 40: 259-62. Also Internat. J. Surg, 1929, 42: 66-70.— Henry, M. O. Proximal osteosynthesis in intracapsular frac- ture of the hip. J. Bone Surg, 1931, 13: 530-7.------ Treatment of intracapsular fractures of the hip. Minnesota M, 1933, 16: 263-7. ------ Intracapsular fractures of the hip; a new device for lateral osteosynthesis. J. Bone Surg, 1934, 16: 168-72. ------ Treatment of fresh fractures of the hip. Minnesota M, 1935, 18: 91-3. ------ Lateral intro- duction of the screw-bolt in intracapsular fracture of the hip. J. Bone Surg, 1938, 20: 4C0-4.—Hudson, R. T. Fracture of the hip; the present status of its treatment. So th. M. J, 1941, 34: 1154.—Johnson, M. A, jr. Treatment o( fractures of the hip by use of the Smith-Petersen pin. Virginia M. Month, 1930-37, 63: 397-404.—Jwnkin, H. D. Hip fracture treatment by the Roger Anderson technic. Illinois M. J, 1937, 71: 199.—Krida, A. Intracapsular fracture of the hip: a new technic of operation. Surg. Clin. N. America, 1930, 16: 727- 13.—Miller, O. L. The management of fractures of the hip in the elderly; abduction method. South. M. & S, 1927, 89: 88-91.------Roberts, W. M, & Winkler, H. Internal fixation (blind nailing) in the treatment of fractures of the hip. Ibid, 1937 99: 169-74.—Mogavero, F. Fractures of the hip joint. Am. J. Surg, 1938, 40: 447-50.—Moore, A. T. Frac- ture of the hi]) joint; a new method of skeletal fixation. J. b. Carolina M. Ass, 1934, 30: 199-205. ■------ Fracture of the hip joint; a new method of treatment. Internat. Surg. Digest, Hagerst, 1935, 19: 323-30.------Fracture of the hip joint: treatment by extra-articular fixation with adjustable nails. Surg. Gyn. Obst, 1937, 64: 420-36.—Moore, G. A. Ihe use of a flexed plaster spica case in the treatment of hip fractures Ann. Surg, 1928, 87: 111-23.—Morrison, G. M. Hip nailing' J. Maine M. Ass, 1939, 30: 213-5.—Norton, P. L, & Ilfeld, F. An adaptation of the Balkan frame for developing motion and abduction of the hip. J. Bone Surg, 193S, 20: 224-6 — Novachenko, N. P. [Treatment of fractures of the hip] Orlop travmat, 1931, 5: 37; 50.—O'Donoghue, A. F. Fractures of the hip; a plea for internal fixation. Nebraska M. J, 1939, 24: 329-33.—Osteosynthese de la hanche par une vis plantee dans la tete f6morale au travers du toit de la cavite cotyloide Techn. chir. Par, 1939, 31: 103-10.—Potts, F. N. Comments on the present mode and treatment of a fracture of the hip Physiother. Rev, 1937, 17: 90.—Robertson, R. C. A leg holder for hip nailing. J. Bone Surg.. 1938, 20: 782. ------ Frac- tures of the hip; 4 years experience with Moore nails. South Surgeon, 1940, 9: 884-99.—Rountree, C. R. Experiences with internal fixation in fractures of the hip. J. Oklahoma M. Ass 1939, 32: 317-25.—Sloane, D. A simple fixation guide for fractured hips. Surg. Gyn. Obst, 1938, 67: 354.—Stern, W. G, Reich, R. R. [et al.] The treatment of intracapsular fracture of the hip joint; by the method of extension, abduction,, and internal rotation (Whitman's method) with especial reference to the group age 60 and beyond. Ibid, 1931, 53: 250-4.— Stewart, D. M. A simpler method of internal fixation of frac- tures of the hip. Ohio M. J, 1939, 35: 380-4.—Stuck, W. G. Pitfalls in the treatment of fractures of the hip. Med. Rec, Houston, 1940, 34: 390-2. Also repr.—Thornton, L, & Sandi- son, C. Recognition of the modern treatment of broken hips. Bull. Fulton Co. M. Soc, 1936, 10: No. 14, 6. Also repr. Also South. M. J, 1936, 29: 456-60.— Tobin, W. J. A splint to increase hip and knee motion. J. Bone Surg, 1941, 23: 712.— Travers, M. P. Ambulatory treatment of fractures of the hip and spine. J. Florida M. Ass, 1936-37, 23: 574-9.—Venable, C. S, & Stuck, W. G. Vitallium nails in fractures of the hip. Surg. Gyn. Obst, 1940, 70: 964r8. Also repr.—Watson-Jones, R. Simple traction table for hip nailing operations. Brit. M. J, 1937, 2: 751.—Weigel, E. P. Fijacion interna en las frac- turas de la cadera. Cir. ortop. traumat, Habana, 1938, 6: 121-31.—White, J. W. An instrument facilitating use of the flanged nail in treatment of fractures of the hip. J. Bone Surg, 1935, 17: 1065.—Whitman, R. The operative treatment of ununited fracture at the hip. Surg. Gyn. Obst./ 1926, 43: 221-3. ------ The abduction treatment, a standard pro- cedure for all forms of fractures at the hip joint. Am. Surg, 1928, 87: 442-9. Also Lancet, Lond, 1931, 2: 726-30. ------ The abduction method; considered as the exponent of a treat- ment for all forms of fracture at the hip in accord with surgical principles. Am. J. Surg, 1933, 21: 335-44. Also repr. ---- Fracture, ununited. Albee, F. H. Ununited fractures of the hip. Internat. J. Surg, 1927, 40: 49-55.—Brown, L. T. Pelvic inclination: a factor in slipped epiphysis and nonunion of fracture of the hip. N. England J. M, 1937, 216: 233-6.—Cooperman, M. B. The Whitman reconstruction operation on the hip joint for ununited intracapsular fracture; with report of a case. Med. J. & Rec, 1925, 122: 194.—Dean, E. F. Treatment of non- union of fractures at the neck of the femur with tapered pins. Colorado M, 1929, 26: 163-5.—Evans, E. T. Treatment of non-union fracture of the hip. Minnesota M, 1935, 18: 93.— Hsnderson, M. S. Ununited fracture of the hip. Ann. Surg, 1926, 83: 696-703. ------ Nonunion of fractures of the hip. Surg. J, 1926-27, 33: 105-8. ------ Bone graft for ununited fracture of the hip. Proc. Mayo CUn, 193i, 6: 17-9.—Her- mann, O. J. Ununited hip fractures. N. England J. M, 1942, 226: 601-5.—Meyerding, H. W. Ununited fracture of the hip, with fibula used as a bone graft. Surg. Clin. N. America, 1927, 7: 1433-5.—Wagner, L. C. A plastic operation for ununited fracture of the hip. Am. J. Surg, 1929, n. ser, 6: 801. Also repr.—Zadek, I. Whitman reconstruction operation for ununited fracture of the hip. Ibid, 1927, n. ser, 3: 78. ---- Injury See also subheading Fracture. Bazy. Les contusions de la hanche. Rev. gin. clin. ther, 1929, 43: 849.—Berard, L, Vignard & Berard, M. Curieuse histo'ire d un schrapnell de la hanche gauche toiere pendant 15 ans. Lyon chir, 1935, 32: 489-93.—Condamin, F. Fracture de la branche iliopubienne et contusion de la hanche. Lyon med 1926, 138: 266-8.—Fractures and other injuries of the hip 'Bull. Chicago M. Soc, 1935, 37: 445-50— Glissan. D. J. A rare hip injury. Med. J. Autralia, 1935, 2: 699.—Guermon- prez F Un traumatisme obscur de la hanche; entorse coxo- iemorale. J. sc. med. Lille, 1923, 41: 69-74.—Guilleminet. Traumatisme de la hanche. Lyon med, 1926, 138: 303-7.— Lamarque & Roques. De l'insuffisance de l'incidence de face dans l'examen radiologique des traumatismes de la hanche. Bull. Soc. eiectroradiol. med. France, 1939, 27: 680.—Mul- holland J H. First aid treatment of fracture of femur and hip Am. J. Surg, 1937, 36: 323-7.—Niederecker, K. Die traumatischen Verletzungen der Hiifte; Entstehen, Behandlung und Endausgange auf Grund des lOjiihrigen Anstaltsmatenals. Arch orthop. UnfaUchir, 1933, 33: 567-79.—Parmenov, V. I. Case of gunshot wound of the hip, complicated wounding of the'urinarv bladder and rectum] Khirurgia, Moskva, 1938, No 12 119.—Patel, J. Semeiologie des lesions traumatiques recentes de la hanche. Presse med, 1933, 41: 1259.—Pitman, E. B. Hip injuries and nursing care. Am. J. Nurs, 1940, 40: HIP 395-400.—Schroeder. E. F. Injuries in the region of the hip in small animals. J. Am. Vet. M. Ass, 1930, 89: 522-45 — Schrocder. R. L. The management of injuries of the hip in the aged. Nebra.-ka M. J, 1930, 15: 439-42. ---- Muscles. See also names of muscles; also Buttock; Thigh. Ferri, G. Coxite simulata da corps estraneo (ago) migrato nei muscoli adduttori della coscia. BoU. spec. med. chir, 1927, 1: 288-92, pl.—Merklen, R. Essai sur le systeme musculaire dans les coxarthries. J. med. Paris, 1928, 47: 307.—Mommsen. F. GUedermechanische Untersuchungen an einem Beinmodell; I'ntcrsuchungen iiber die Einzelwirkungen und Synergismen der Huftmuskeln in der Normalstellung. Zschr. Anat. Entw, 1936-37, 106: 473-96.—Storck, H. Die Kbrperhaltung bei einseitiger Beinbelastung und ihre Aenderung bei Ausfall der Huftabductionsmuskeln. Arch, orthop. UnfaUchir, 1931, 30: 299-307. ---- Osteochondritis deformans [juvenilis; Legg-Calve-Perthes] Hopf, R. *Zur Osteochondritis deformans juvenilis coxae [Zurich] 30p. 8? Laupen, 1932. Klimke, R. *Die Perthes'sche Erkrankung. 26p. 8? Greifswald, 1930. M0ller, F. P. *Malum deformans coxae infantile: Calve-Perthes'sygdom. 268p. 8? Kbh., 1924. Aimes, A. Ce qu'il faut connaitre de l'osteochondrite de la hanche. Rev. med. fr, 1938, 19: 527-32.—Bachmann, P. La coxa-plana. Echo med. nord, 1935, 3. ser, 3: 33-56.— Balestra, G. Sulla coxa plana. Arch, radiol. Nap, 1929, 5: 767-83.—Biering, G. [Case of Calve-Perthes' disease] Hos- pitalstidende, 1938, 81: [Dansk. radiol. selsk. forh.] 32-9 — Billet, H. Un cas de coxa plana. J. sc. med. Lille, 1927, 45: 85-9, pl.—Branan, J. H. Osteochondritis deformans juvenilis coxae. J. Florida M. Ass, 1935-36, 22: 160-4—Calot, F. Sur le dernier cas de coxa plana envoy6 k la Societe de chi- rurgie. Vie med, 1926, 7: 843.—Climescu, V, & Ghimus, D. [Case of osteochondritis juvenilis] Rev. st. med, Bucur, 1926, 15: 1118-23.—Cunningham, S. R. Osteochondritis deformans juvenilis. J. Oklahoma M. Ass, 1931, 24: 13.— Elward, J. F, & Bier, R. A. A case of bilateral osteochondritis deformans juvenilis coxae (Legg-Caive-i'erthes disease) Radiology, 1936, 27: 63-7.—Evans. T. G. A case of Perthe's disease of the hip. Brit. M. J, 1928, 2: 100.—Ferguson, A. B, & Howorth, M. B. Coxa plana and related conditions at the hip. J. Bone Surg, 1934, 16: 781-803.—Fernando, B. E. Pseudo- coxalgia. J. Ceylon Brit. M. Ass, 1934, 31: 37-43.—Freund, E. A case of atypical Perthes' disease. Am. J. Roentg, 1934, 32: 353-7.—Friderichsen. H. [Case of Calve-Perthe's disease] Ugeskr. laeger, 193:!, 95: 905-7.—Ginsburg-Melamed, R. [Osteochondritis juvenilisl Okhr. zdorov. diet, 1931. 1: 188-99.—Goldfain, E. Perthe's disease. U. S. Veterans Bur. M. Bull, 1926, 2: 610-3.—Gomez, J. A. Un caso de enferme- dad de Perthes-Calv6. Arch, espan. pediat, 1931, 15: 87- 100.—Haas, S. L. Osteochondritis deformans juvenilis coxae. In Cyclop. Med. (Piersol-Bortz) Phila, 1939, 3: 34-6.— Hagen, W. H. Coxa plana; report of 2 bilateral cases in broth- ers. J. Bone Surg, 1939, 21: 1028-30—Hamdi Bako [Four analogical cases of Legg-Calve-Perthes (Waldenstrom) disease] Askeri sihhiye mccmuasi, 1940, 69: No. 31, 51-8.—Hoffmeister, \V. Uebei Epiphysenschwund am Femurkopf (Osteochondritis deformans juvenilis) Deut. Zschr. Chir, 1927, 203:-204: 449-63.—Judet, H. L'osteochondrite de la hanche. Rev. m6d. fr, 1931, 12: 575-85.—Kidner, F. C. An unusual case of Legg-Perthes' disease. J. Bone Surg, 1926, 8: 565-9.— Ksieniewicz, W. [Osteochondritis of the hip] Lek. wojsk, 1936, 27: 353-60.—Lamy, L, & Hausler. L'osteochondrite deformante infantile de la hanche (coxa plana, ou maladie de Calve-Legg-Perthes) Sem. hop. Paris, 1931, 7: 110-7 — Lance. Deux observations d'osteochondrite de la hanche. Bull. Soc. nat. chir. Par, 1927, 53: 030-8.—Lasserre, C Osteochondrite de l'extremite superieure du femur. J. med. Bordeaux, 1935, 112: 682.—Lewis, H. A case of Perthe's disease. J. M. Ass. S. Africa, 1927, 1: 391.—Loheac, P. Un cas de coxa-plana. J. sc. med. Lille, 1926, 44: 85^90.— MacMurray, W. Case of Legg's or Perthes' disease. New- castle M. J, 1922-23, 3: 110-4.—Maselli, V. Dell'osteo- condrius e dell'osteoartrite giovanile deformante dell'anca. Chir. mg. movim, 1934-35, 19: 13-50.—Moltzen-Nielsen, H. < ;,!ve-l'erthes-Krankheit, Malum deformans juveniUs coxae bt-i Hunden. Arch. wiss. prakt. Tierh, 1937, 72: 91-108.— Moreau. Sur un cas d'osteochondrite deformante infantile de la hanche. Arch, electr. med, 1927, 37: 192-5.—Nagasaka, K. Clinical studies on osteochondritis deformans coxae juveniUs (Calv6-Le£g-Perthes' disease) Fukuoka acta med, 1929, 22: 26-8.—Nicolaysen. K. [Case of Calve-Legg-Perthes' disease of the hip; cases] Norsk mag. laegevid, 1931, 92: 985-9, 2 pl.— Novachenko, N. P. [Perthes' disease of the head of the femur and of the cotyloid cavity] Ortop. travmat, 1934, 8: 4.5-60, 9 pl.—Opazo, F, & Gebauer, T. Necrosis aseptica epifisiaria, coxa-plana. ostcoconihois deformans coxae juvenilis, enfer- medad de Calve, Legg, Perthes. Bol. Soc. cir. Chile, 1933, 11: 373-7.—Finkhasik, M. I. [Case of osteochondropathy of the HIP neck of the femur] Vest, rentg, 1936, 16: 138-41.—-Pinto de Miranda, F. Osteo-condrites coxo-femurais. Lisboa med, 1933, 10: 348-03—Priesel. R., & Siesl. J. Osteochondritis non luetica im Snuglingsaltor. Arch. Kinderh, 1935, 10.">: 14—20.—Pyhus, F. B. Pseudo-coxalgia (Perthe's disease) Newcastle M. J, 1922-2:',, 3: 97.- Rao, N. M. Osteo-chon- dritis juvenilis. Madras M. .1, 1931, 13: 157-07.- Roederer. C. Osteochondrite de la hanche suivi pendant 3'j ans (case) Bull. Soc. nat. chir. Par.. 1920, 52: 950-5. Quelques observations d'osteochondrite do la hanche. P. verb. Congr. fr. chir, 1926, 35: 468-73.--Rojko, A. [Osteochondiitis coxae juvenilisl Gy6gy:iszat, 1930, 70: 373-6. -Ruiz Moreno, M, 4 Jorge. Osteocondritis deformante de la cadera. Hoi. Soc. cir. B. Aires, 1935, 19: 1086-91.—Srarlini, G. Sulla coxa plana congenita. Atti Soc. lombard. sc. med, 1926, 15: 73-83.—Slocum, D. B. Coxa plana. Northwest M, 1941, 40: 233-8.—Snodgrass, L. E. Perthes' disease. J. Hone Surg, 1932, 14: 314-24.—Soler Terol, M. La osteocondritis infantil de la cadera. Ars med, Barcel, 1929, 5: 287-90.- Sonnauer, P. [Osteochondritis deformans coxae juvenilis (Perthes- Calve-Legg)] Orv. hetil, 1937, 81: mell, 30.—Soricelli, F. Un caso di osteocondrite deformante giovanile dell'anca in A. 0. I. Riv. med. trop, 1940, 4: 93-7.—Spicer, A. Osteo- chondritis deformans coxae (Perthes' disease) suspected case in the dog. Vet. Rec, Lond, 1936, 16: 325, pl.—Sterin, R. La coxa plana. Bull, med. Par, 1937, 51: 667-74— Szabo, I. [Az osteochondritis deformans juvenilis coxae] Magy. rontg. kozl, 1934, 8: 69-75.— Takao, H. Ueber die Perthessche Krankheit (Osteochondritis deformans coxae juvenilis) Oka- yama igakkai zasshi, 1936, 48: 1735, 2 pl.—Taylor, C. W. Legg-Perthes disease. Univ. Toronto M. J, 1939-40, 17: 171-6.—Trinca, A. J. Legg's disease. Med. J. Australia, 1927, 1: 928.—Wakeley, C. P. G. l'seudocoxalgia in a girl aged 5. Proc. R. Soc. M, Lond, 1927-28, 21: Sect. Clin, 39. ----- Pseudocoxalgia in a boy aged 4 years. Ibid, 50-2. ----- Bilateral pseudocoxalgia. Ibid, 1928-29, 22: Sect. Clin, 5.—Wardill, W. E. M. Pseudo-coxalgia (Legg's disease, Perthes' disease) Newcastle M. J, 1921-22, 2: 18-24, pl.— Wassink, W. F. [A case of osteochondritis juveniUs coxan duplex] Ned. tschr. geneesk, 1927, 71: 2179-82.—Wedeklnd. Osteochondritis deformans juvenilis coxae. Med. KUn, Beak, 1927, 23: 1469. ---- Osteochondritis deformans: Diagnosis. Thiemann, A. *Kann man aus dem Rontgen- bild auf die Entstehung der Osteochondral deformans juvenilis coxae schliessen? [Munster] 21p. 8? Quakenbruck, 1937. Abragov, V. 1. [Roentgen picture of the evolution of the bone structure in Calve's disease] Ortop. travmat, 1937, 11: 57-63, 3 pl.—Brandes. Die Anfangsbefunde der juvenilen Osteo- chondritis deformans coxae (Perthes) im Rontgenbild (mit Projektionen) Verb. |Deut. orthop. Ges. (1925) 1926, 20. Kongr, 72-0 [Discussion] 96-101.—Colaco Belmonte, A. [Case of Legg-Calve-Perthes disease of the hip with symptoms leading to an erroneous diagnosis] Ned. tschr. geneesk, 1932, 76: pt 3, 4507, 2 pl.—Confalonieri, D. Le malattie di Perthes e di Osgood-Schlatter dal punto di vista della diagnosi differenziale con la tbc. articolare. PoUclinico, 1934, 41: sez. prat, 1211-6.— Dueno, F. P. La enfermedad de Perthes; estudio clinico y radiologico (con observation de 6 casos) Arch, med, Madr, 1929, 31: 193-207.—Freund, E. Zur Deutung des Rontgen- bildes der Perthesschen Krankheit. Fortsch. Rontgenstrahl, 1930,42: 435-64.—Gage, H. C. A possible early sign of Perthes' disease. Brit. J. Radiol, 1933, 6: 295-7.—Gill, A. B. Legg- Perthes disease of the hip; its early roentgenographic manifes- tations and its cyclical course. J. Bone Surg, 1940, 22: 1013- 47.—Giitig, D, & Herzog, A. Die aseptische Schcnkelhals- nekrose bei Jugendlichen; Osteochondritis juvenilis des Schen- kelhalses. Rontgenpraxis, 1932, 4: 504-13. ------ Die aseptische Schenkelhalsnekrose bei Jugendlichen; Beginn, Verlauf und Differentialdiagnose. Wien. med. Wschr, 1936, 86: 969. Also Fortsch. Rontgenstrahl, 1937, 56: 201 — Heydemann, H. Osteochondritis oder Tuberkulose dea Hiiftgelenkes. Med. Welt, 1932, 6: 701-4.—Irrmann, E. Les lesions radiologiques precoces de la coxalgie et de l'osteo- chondrite de la hanche; leur diagnostic differentiel. Rev. orthop. Par, 1928, 3. ser, 15: 392-410. Also Strasbourg med, 1928, 86: pt 2, 223-37.—Krukenberg, H. Beitrage zur Kennt- nis der Perthesschen Krankheit. Zschr. orthop. Chir, 1930, 53: 176-89.—Lewis, R. W. Correlation of roentgen and patho- logic findings in Perthes' disease. Radiology, 1934, 22: 188- 90.—Oliete, A. Contribuci6n al diagnostico diferencial radiografico entre la enfermedad de Perthes y la artritis tuber- culosa de la cadera. Progr. clin, Madr, 1932, 40: 325-30.— Orth. Zur Kasuistik und Begutachtung der Perthesschen Krankheit. Munch, med. Wschr, 1931, 78: 65. —Pattison, C. L. Pseudocoxalgia; cUnical evidence, X-ray appearance, etiology, and treatment; with a review of 25 cases. Brit. J. Surg, 1928-29, 16: 89-105.—Sainz de los Terreros, C, & Lacalle, E. iEnfermedad de Perthes o de Morquio? heredo- distrofia osteo-articular coxo-femoral. An. Hosp. S. Jose, Madr, 1933-34, 5: 117-28—Sakhachiev, A. Ueber Rontgen- diagnose von Osteochondritis deformans coxae juvenUis. Fortsch. Rontgenstrahl, 1933, 48: 54-61.—Simons, B. Zur Rontgendiagnose der Osteochondritis deformans coxae juve- niUs. Ibid, 591.—Williams, E. G. G. The condition caUed Perthes' disease. Radiology, 1926, 7: 337-9. HIP 671 HIP --- Osteochondritis deformans: Etiology, and pathogenesis. Define, D. *Etio-patogenia da coxa-plana; estudo experimental. 84p. 26}£cm. Sao Paulo, 1939. Munk, G. *Perthes'sche Krankheit und Eruahrung [Erlangen] 34p. 8? Kallmiinz, 1930. Port, J. *Bedcutet die Theorie Murk Jansens iiber die Entstehung der Coxa plana einen Fort- schritt gegeniiber den bisherigen Erklarungs- versuchen? 37p. 8? Wiirzb., 1926. Seltmann [W.] S. *Ueber die Aetiologie der Perthesschen Krankheit [Leipzig] 32p. 8: Zeulenroda, 1938. Soentgen, W. *Traumatischer Perthes [Munster] 28p. 8? Diisseld., 1934. Sterin, R. M. Contribution a l'etude de la coxa plana. 137p. 8? Par., 1937. Widenhorn, H. *Theoretische und experi- mentelle Beitrage zur Entstehungsursache der Osteochondritis juvenilis deformans coxae. 31p. 8? Freib. i. B., 1926. Wildikann, A. *Ueber Deformierungen des Oberschenkclkopfes und der Huftpfanne im Sinne der Perthes'schen Krankheit (Osteochon- dritis coxae juveniUs) als Folgeerscheinung der unblutigen Einrenkung der angeborenen Htift- gelenksluxation. 16p. 8? Jena, 1932. Bcntzon, P. G. K. Experimental studies on the patho- genesis of coxa plana (Calve-Legg-Perthes-Waldenstrom's dis- ease) and other manifestations of local dvschondroplasia. Acta radiol, Stockh, 1926, 6: 155-72, 4 pl.—Berard & Santy. Coxa-plana et luxation congenitale de la hanche. Lyon chir., 1923, 20: 402.-—Berry, J. M. A theory as to the cause of Perthes' disease based on roentgenologic findings. J. Bone Surg, 1926, 8: 333-47.—Billet. H. Luxation congenitale et coxa-plana. J. sc. med. Lille, 1926, 44: 301-5.—Bolzinger & Hamon. Osteochondrite de la hanche chez un her6do-syphiliti- que. Bull. Soc. med. mil. fr, 1936, 30: 244-7.—Borchard. A. Ueber Perthessche Krankheit und Unfall. Mschr. Unfallh, 1932, 39: 317-9.—Calot. F. Le pretendue coxa-plana est une malfor- mation congenitale meconnue. P. verb. Congr. fr. chir, 1922, 31: 955-63. ------ Le vraie nature de ce qu'on appelle osteo-chondrite ou coxa-plana. J. sc. m6d. Lille, 1923, 41: 416-9. ------ La lesion baptisee osteochondrite ou coxa plana est une subluxation congenitale meconnue. Monde med, 1928. 38:433-43, pl. ------ Dans la pretendus osteochondrite le cotyle est toujours malforme, en voici la preuve sur un cotyle publie comme normal. P. verb. Congr. fr. chir, 1928. 37: 1053-5.—Choyce, C. C. Traumatic dislocation of the hip in childhood, and relation of trauma to pseudocoxalgia; analysis of 59 cases published up to January, 1924. Brit. J. Surg, 1924- 25, 12: 52-9.—Delchef. J. A propos de I'etiologie et de la pathogenie de l'osteochondrite de la hanche; relation d'un cas, etude clinique, radiographique et anatomique. Rev. orthop. Par, 1926, 3. ser, 13: 5-21.—Durham, H. A, & Outland, T. A. Blood calcium and phosphorus in Perthes' disease; a new con- ception of the etiology. J. Bone Surg, 1928, 10: 301-5 — Elmslie, R. C. Traumatic dislocation of the hip in a child, aged 7, with subsequent development of coxa plana. Proc. R. Soc. M, Lond, 1932, 25:1100.—Fairbank, H. A. T. Case of pseudo- coxalgia following traumatic dislocation in a boy. Ibid, 1923- 24, 17: Sect. Orthop, 40.—Fischl, E. Beobachtungen uber die Osteochondritis deformans coxae juvenilis, zugleich ein Beitrag zur Pathogenese der Epiphysenlosung am coxalen Femurende. Arch, orthop. UnfaUchir, 1933, 33: 456-63.—Fitte, M, & Olascoaga, M. L. Seudo-coxalgias por osteomielitis. Prensa med. argent, 1938, 25: 1197-207.—Freund, E. Ueber die von Kreuz beschriebenen ungewohnlichen Veriinderungen an den Hiiftkopfepiphysen. Fortsch. Rontgenstrahl, 1930, 41: 935- 40.—Gamboa, M, & Salvati, A. A. La osteocondritis defor- mante de la cadera; etiopatogenia y tratamiento quirtirgico. Bol. Soc. cir. B. Aires, 1935, 19: 907-24.—Gaugele. Die Perthessche Erkrankung der Hufte, eine Subluxatio coxae (Calot)? Verb. Deut. orthop. Ges. [1930] 1931, 25. Kongr, 58-65.—Gioia, T. A prop6sito de un caso de osteocondritis deformante juvenil en un accidentado del trabajo. Sem. med, B. Air, 1933, 40: 1138-43.—Goldenberg, R. R. Traumatic dislocation of the hip followed by Perthes' disease. J. Bone Surg, 1938, 20: 770-4.—Gonzalez-Aguilar, J. La patogenia de la enfermedad de Perthes, y la patogenia de la osificacion endocondral. Arch, med, Madr, 1931, 34: 349-57—Gorale- wski, G, & Engel, E. Ein Beitrag zur Frage der Aetiologie der Osteochondritis coxae juveniUs-Perthes. llcintgenpraxis, 1932, 4: 745 —Graham, R. V. Experimental considerations in Perthes's disease. Med. J. Australia, 1930, 1: 207-9, 4 pl — Grignon, C. E. Osteochondrite femorale juvenile et troubles endocriniens. Union med. Canada, 1938, 67: 144.—Guibal. P. Osteo-chondrite deformante et hypertrophiante de l'extremite supeneure du femur par exostose de croissance. Arch fr belg chir 1922 25: 644-51, pl.—Halpern, S, & Niesnievichi L. llitiology of Perthes' disease in conjunction with pluri- glandular insufficientia] Med. biol. J, Leningr, 1926 2- J • 48758-—Hawk'ns, T. L. Osteochondritis in adolescence and its relation to trauma. J. Lancet, 1934, 54: 619.—Hilgen- reiner. H. Beitrag zur Aetiologie der Osteochondritis cosae juvenilis. Med. Klin, Berl, 1933, 29: 494-8.—Ingelrans, P. Coxa plana bilaterale ayant evolue sur des hanches parfaite- ment normales. Rev. orthop. Par, 1926, 3. ser, 13: 23-34.— Just, E. Zur Aetiologie der Osteochondritis coxae juvenilis deformans. Wien. klin. Wschr, 1931, 44: 889-92.—Kaiser, H. Ueber famihares Auftreten von Osteochondritis deformans eoxae (Perthes) Wien. Arch. inn. Med, 1928, 16: 61-72.— Koch, C. F. Coxa vara en arthritis deformans juvenilis (sub- luxation coxa congenita) Ned. tschr. geneesk, 1927, 71: 307- 13, pl.—Kraft, R. Zur traumatischen Grundlage der Osteo- chondritis coxae juvenilis deformans. Deut. Zschr. Chir, 1931, 233: 345-54.—Legg, A. De la maladie caracterisee par l'apla- tissement de l'epiphyse superieure du femur. Arch. fr. belg. chir, 1922, 25: 585-91, 4 pl.—Leriche, R. Recherches experi- mentales sur le mecanisme de formation de l'osteochondrite de la hanche. Lyon chir, 1934, 31: 610-20.—Lindemann, K, & Siemens, W. Betrachtungen iiber das Wesen der Perthesschen Krankheit, unter besonderer Berucksichtigung der Pfannen- veranderungen. Zschr. orthop. Chir, 1933, 60: 65-97.— Lippmann, R. K. The pathogenesis of Legg-Calve-Perthes' disease based upon the pathologic findings in a case. Am. J. Surg, 1929, n. ser, 6: 785-91.—Magyary, G. [Pathogenesis of the osteochondritis deformans juvenilis coxae] Orvoskepzes, 1933, 23: Jun. Kulonf, Dolgozatok, 384-9, pl.—Miltner, L. J, & Hu, C. H. Osteochondritis of the head of the femur; an experimental study. Arch. Surg, 1933, 27: 045-57. Also Proc. Soc. Exp. Biol, N. Y, 1933, 30: 416.—Nagasaka, K. On the pathogenesis and etiology of the osteochondritis de^ formans coxae juvenilis (Calve-Legg-Perthes) Fukuoka acta med, 1930, 23: 27.—Nagura, S. Zur pathogenese der Perthes- schen Krankheit; zugleich Erwiderung auf die AViderlegung von Tapavicza im Arch. klin. Chir. 198. Bd, H. 3. Arch. kUn. Chir, 1941, 201: 334-8 (microfilm)—Nielsen, B. [Calve- Perthes' disease foUowing fracture of the neck of the femur in the young and its significance in the pathogenesis of aseptic necrosis of the epiphysis] Hospitalstidende, 1938, 81: 773- 88.—Oberzimmer, J. Esiste un rapporto tra lussazione con- genita dell'anca e osteocondrite giovanile? Chir. org. movim, 1933-34, 18: 233-42.—Panagia, A. Osteocondrite deformante giovanile o sublussazione congenita dell'anca? Gior. med. mil, 1935, 73: 148-58.—Quervain, F. de. Ueber das Wesen der sogenannten Osteochondritis juveniUs des Hiiftgelenkes. Schweiz. med. Wschr, 1928, 58: 163.—Rocher, H. L. L'au- thenticite et l'autonomie de l'epiphysite femorale, denommee osteochondrite de la hanche ou coxa-plana; etude radiologique et anatomo-pathologique de 4 cas. Arch, electr. med, 1927, 37: 177-91.------L'epiphysite femorale denommee osteochon- drite de la hanche ou coxa-plana existe-t-elle en tant qu'affection autonome? Arch. fr. belg. chir, 1927, 30: 24-9.—Rockemer, K. Zur Histopathogenese der Perthesschen Krankheit, an der Hand eines Fruhfalles. Frankf. Zschr. Path, 1927, 35: 1-21.— Roedcrer, C. La querelle de l'osteochondrite. Arch. med. chir. province, 1927, 17: 59-61. Also J. med. Paris, 1927, 46: 71.— Sandoz, A. Beitrag zur Frage der Osteochondritis deformans juveniUs (Calve-Logg-Perthessche Krankheit) Beitr. klin. Chir, 1928, 143: 189-236.—Scholz, A. Rontgenologische Beckenstudien zur Frage des Zusammenhangs der Osteo- chondritis deformans coxae juvenilis und der angeborenen Subluxation der Hufte, wie es von Calot behauptet wild. Arch. orthop. UnfaUchir, 1928, 26: 572-80.—Spisi6, B. Ueber den kongenitalen Charakter juveniler Osteochondritiden des Hiiftgelenkes. Zschr. orthop. Chir, 1929, 52: 60-72.—Tamini. Osteocondritis deformante de la cadera; etiopatogenia y trata- miento. Bol. Soc. cir. B. Aires, 1935, 19: 944-6.—Viana Giuria, C. A. Algunos aspectos de la osteocondritis de la cadera; sus relaciones con la osteocondrosis de origen tiroideo. Arch. urug. med, 1940, 16: 358-66.—Winter, H. Die Perthessche Krank- heit im Lichte neuer Stoffwechseluntersuchungen. Zschr. orthop. Chir, 1929-30, 52: 592-002.—Zemansky, A. P, jr. The pathology and pathogenesis of Legg-Calve-Perthes' dis- ease (osteochondritis juvenilis deformans coxae) Am. J. Surg, 1928, n. ser, 4: 169-84.------& Lippmann, R. K. The importance of the vessels in the round ligament to the head of the femur during the period of growth, and their possible relationship to Perthes' disease. Surg. Gyn. Obst, 1929, 48: 461-9. ---- Osteochondritis deformans: Pathology. Bieneck, E. *Ueber Epiphysenschwund am Htiftgelenk [Munchen] 36p. 8? Giinzb.- Donau, 1937. Bosien, K. *Ueber Lokalisation, Form und Grosse der Epiphyseonekrose bei der Perthes'- schen Erkrankung des Huftgelenks [Kiel] 53p. 22^cm. Berl., 1937. Chruscz, E. *Beiderseitiger Perthes bei Klumpfuss. 37p. 8? Bresl., 1925. HIP 672 HIP JorcHNovETsKY [J.] A. *Ost t'ochondrite et luxation congenitale de la hanche. 44p. 8; Par., 1920. .R\uiAX, H. [J. F.] *Beitrag zur Osteochon- dritis dissecans des Femurkopfes; eine Zusam- menfassung aller bisher veroffcntlichten Beob- achtungen unter gleichzeitiger Mitteilung eincr neuen Beobachtung [Berlin] 32p. 8? Charlot- tenb. [1938] Stamer, E. *Coxa vara und Malum coxae juvenile, ihre Unterschiede und Beziehungen [Munchen] 38p. S? Speyer, 1935. Scndt, H. *Unders0kelser over Malum coxae (Calv6, Legg, Perthes) 229p. 8? Kristiania, 1920. Arce, F.. & Arce, M. Relaci6n entre la^ osteocondritis deformante infantil de la epifisis superior del femur y la sub- luxaci6n o luxacion congenita de cadera. Arch, med, Madr, 1927, 26: 446-9, pl.—Biezins, A. Ueber die Osteochondritis subepiphysarea. Acta Soc. med. Duodecim, 1939, ser. B, 27: No. 22, 1-13.—Boerema, I. Ueber die Perthessche Krankheit mit besonderer Beriicksichtigung des Ischium varum und der Subluxation des Femurkopfes. Fortsch. Rontgenstrahl, 1931, 44: 473-80.—Burrows. H. J. Coxa plana; with special reference to it- pathology and kinship. Brit. J. Surg, 1941-42, 29: 23-30.—Calot. (Joe rtstt-t-il de- ustepchondrites de la hanche'.' Me l'osi e. .chondni e juvenile et ds I osteochondrite dis-equante) p. vol.. C'onar. fr. do:.. 1934. 43: 1001-6.— Cavanaugh, I, A, Srieltcn. b. K, & Sutlierland. R. Metabolic studies in ost.-i.etiondrititl i.f tie- capital femoral epiphysis. .1. Bone Surg., I'.i.Ki. 18:957 il*. ■—l).i\id. S. 1). 1 .egg's disease in its late stage. South. M. .1.. 192S. 21: 522 7.— Fltrart. J. Coxa plana/Coxitis acuta mid Ligamentttm tires. Acta chir. scand, 1027, 62: 454-64.- -Fcdersi limidt. Wesen, Ablauf und Endzustande der Osteochondritis deformans juveniUs. Ver- einsbl. pfiilz. Aerzte, 1926, 38: 33-7.—Gavrilescu. S. [Osteo- chondritis deformans juvenilis of the femora I. superior epiphyses] Hev. ?t. med, Bucur, 1930, 19: 1040-62.—Hiissler, E. Juvenile Osteochondropathie am Huftgelenkpfahnendach. Rontgenpraxis, 1934, 6: 548.—Iala. Osteocondrite ed afflusso sanguigno. Morgagni, 1934, 76: 117.—In.'elrans, P., & Bach- mann, P. Coxa plana suppuree a staphylocoques dores. Gaz. med. France, 1934, 451.—Kargus, H. Ueber die Pfannen- veriinderungen bei der Perthesschen Krankheit. Zschr. orthop. Chir, 1933, 59: 90-115.—Konjctzny, G. E. Zur Pathologie und pathologischen Anatomic der Perthes-Calve'schen Krank- heit (Osteochondritis coxae deformans juvenilis) Acta chir. scand, 1931, 74: 361-78- Korvin, H. Zur Frage der priimor- biden Veranderungen bei Perlhoseher Krankheit. Zschr. orthop. Chir, 1933, 59: 76-98.- Lonergan, R. C. Some observations on Legg's disease. Illinois M. J, 1928, 54: 221- 3.- Ma.^troniarino, A. Alterazioni dell'acetabolo nei morbo di Calve-Legg-Perthes. Ann. radiol., Bologna, 1937, 11: 29-51.— Muller, W. Beobachtungen iiber die Kolle der Pfannenver- anderung bei der Perthesschen Krankheit. Fortsch. Rontgen- strahl, 1939, 59: 386-91. ------& Loepp, W. Die Natur der umschriebenen SchenkelhalsaufheUungen bei der Perthesschen Krankheit. Ibid.. 60: 294-3C0 — Nagura, S. Perthessche Krankheit und Coxa vara. Arch. klin. Chir, 1910, 199: 613-8 (microfilm) — Nisio, C Osteocondrite deformante infantile e osteoartrite deformante giovanile sono fasi di una stessa malattia? Policlinico, 1927, 34: sec. chir, 600-12. Osteocondrite deformante infantile e osteoartrite deformante giovanile sono fasi di una stessa malattia? (riassunto) Arch. Soc. ital. chir. (.1927) 1928, 34: 741.—Pich, G. Histo- pathologic study in a case of Perthes' disease of traumatic origin. Arch. Surg, 1936, 33: 609-29.—Piergrossi, A. Sulle lesioni del collo femorale nella osteocondrite infantile dell'anca. Radiol, med, Milano, 1940, 27: 81-108.—Poissonnier, M. Sur la renovation de la pathologie de la hanche, tant medicale que chirurgicale, a tous les ages, et en particulier sur ce qu'il faut penser de l'osteo-chondrite ou coxa-plana. J. sc. med LiUe, 1926, 44: pt 2, 185-94.—Poli, A. Osteocondrite di Perthes ed osteite tubercolare del coUo femorale. Arch, o'top Milano, 1933, 49: 1174-81.—Pcllwein, O. Friih- und Split' stadien der Osteochondritis deformans juvenilis coxae. Beitr klin. Chir. 1925-26, 135: 608-23.—Roederer, C. Une ost6o^ chondrite n'est pas une subluxation congenitale de la hanche Vie med, 1926, 7: 2353-6.—Sorrel, E. Quelques remarques k propos de l'osteochondrite deformante infantile de l'epiphyse femorale superieure. Arch. fr. beige chir, 1922, 25: 625-32, 3 pl.—Tavares. A. Contribucion al estudio de la osteocondritis deformante infantil. Ars medica, Barcel., 1928, 4: 400-6, pl.— Van Assen [Perthes-Calve disease with eoxa vara] ' Ned. tschr. geneesk, 1927, 71: pt 2, 1271.— Waldenstrom, H. The first stages of coxa plana. Acta orthop. scand, 193| Siu-He-Leng. *End;uisgiinge der Osteo- chondritis deformans juvenilis coxae (.IVrthcs'schc Krankheit) [Berlin] 48p. 22^cm. Charlot- tenb., 1937. Caldwell, G. A. End-results of coxa plana as related to treatment. South. M. J, 1934, 27: 402-7.—Legg. A. T. The end results of coxa plana. J. Bone Surg, 1927, 9: 20-30. ----I.egg-Perthes' disease with special reference to prog- nosis anil treatment. Am. .1. Surg., 1929, n. ser., 6: 793.— MOOer. P. F. The clinical observations after healing of Calve- Perthes' disease compared with the final deformities left by that disease, and the bearing of those final deformities on the ultimate prognosis. Acta radiol.. Stool.li., 1926, 5: 1-36.— IWiihlhmdt. Ueber Spatfolgen nach Perthesscher Krankheit. Dent. Xelir. Chir, 1928-29, 213: 243-53.—Schmidt, VV. Die I-'.iidausgange der Osteochondritis coxae juvenilis (Perthes) licitr. klin. Chir, 1934, 160: 2-17-67. ---- Osteochondritis deformans: Treatment. ---- Osteochondritis deformans: Prognosis. Ftjhrmaxx, G. *Endausgange Perthes'scher Krankheit [Munchen] 23p. 21cm. Soever a Rh., 1938. Stoll, D. *Ein Beitrag zur Behandlung der Perthes'schen Krankheit. 39p. 21^cm. Freib. i. B., 1937. Aimes, A. L'operation de Robertson Lavalle dans l'osteo- chondrite de la hanche. P. verb. Congr. fr. chir, 1929, 38: 797-9.—Calve, J. Coxa plana. In Traite chir. orthop. (Ombredanne) Par, 1937, 4: 3259-70.—Danforth, M. S. The treatment of Legg-Calve-Perthes disease without weight- bearing. J. Bone Surg, 1934, 16: 516-34.-—Dominici, L. L'operazione di Lanco in un- caso di osteocondrite deformante dell'anca con sublussazione. Arch. Soc. ital. chir. (1927) 1928, 34: 699-706. Also Bull. Accad. med. 1928. 54: 166-9.—Eyre-Brook, A. L. Osteochondritis deformans coxae juvenilis or Perthes' disease; the results of treatment by traction in recumbency. Brit. J. Surg, 1936, 24: 166-82, 7 pl.— Gaugele, K. Der Pfannenperthes. Zbl. Chir, 1931, 58: 66- 72.—Leriche, R. Evidement sous-chondriquo de la tete f6morale et greffes osteoperiostees pour une osteo-chondrite juvenile. Lyon chir, 1934, 31: 607-10.—Massart, R, & Vidal-Naquei, G. L'osteochondrite de la hanche; maladie de Legg-Calve-Perthes. In their Prat, orthop. Par, 1938, 511- 4.—Nikiforov, E. K. [Perthes' disease and methods of treat- ment] Ortop. travmat, 1934, 8: 34-7.—Pike, M. M. Legg- Perthes disease; with particular regard to treatment. Con- necticut M. J, 1940, 4: 5-11.—Rohling, K. Das Dreibein (zur Behandlung der Perthesschen Erkrankung) Zschr. orthop. UnfaUchir, 1930-31, 29: 539-43.—Schiiller, J. Zur Frage der Behandlung der Perthesschen Krankheit. Deut. Zschr. Chir, 1939, 252: 233-7.—Wassink, W. F. [Surgical treatment of osteochondritis juvenilis coxae] Ned. tschr. geneesk, 1927, 71: 1529-31.—Whitman, R. Observations on Legg-Perthes' disease with particular reference to operative treatment. Am. J. Surg, 1928, n. ser, 4: 185-7. ------ Further observations on the operative treatment of Legg-Perthes' disease. Ibid, 5: 385; 1929, 6: 791. ---- Osteochondritis dissecans [Konig] Behar, H. *Contribution a l'etude de l'ostdochondrite dissequante de la hanche chez l'adulte. 38p. 24cm. Par. [1939] Keyser, E. *Ueber Osteochondritis dissecans (Konig) am Huftgelenk [Wurzburg] 19p. 8? Ochsenfurt, 1935. Magnin, R. *L'osteochondrite dissequante de la hanche. 42p. 8? Par., 1931. Stolear, L. Contribution a l'etude de la maladie de Koenig de la tete f6morale; osteo- chondrite dissequante de la hanche. 56p. 24cm. Par., 1939. Barcaroli, I. L'osteocondrite dissecante. Policlinico, 1931, 38: sez. chir, 590-605.—Basch, G, Sauvage, R, & David, L. Un cas d'osteochondrite dissequante de la hanche. Mem. Acad, chir. Par, 1940, 66: 599-602.—Bergmann, E. Osteo- chondritis dissecans des Huftgelenks. Deut. Zschr. Chir, 1929, 217: 400-5. -Brown, J. J. M. Osteochondritis dissecans of hip. Tr. Med. Chir. Soc. Edinburgh, 1938, 45: 185.— Dyes, O. Morbus Perthes und Osteochondritis dissecans Konig. Zbl. Chir, 1933, 60: 434-41.—Feci, I, Epifisite acuta e osteocondrite dell'anca. Chir. org. movim, 1934, 20: 540- 4.—Filipni, G. Contributo alio studio della osteocondrite dissecante (Konig) Ibid, 1931-32, 16: 35-103.—Francillon, M. R. Lschiometrische Untersuchungen bei Osteochondritis dissecans coxae. Zsehr. orthop. Chir, 1932, 57: 392.- Francon, F. L'osteochondrite dissequante de la hanche; maladie de Koenig de la tete femorale. Rev. rhumat. Par, 1935, 2: 770- 5.—Freund, E. Ueber einen FaU von pBeudoosteochondntis HIP 673 HIP dissecans des Femurkopfes. Arch, orthop. UnfaUchir, 1931. 30: 57-66. •------ Osteochondritis dissecans of the head of the femur; partial idiopathic aseptic necrosis of the femoral head. Arch. Surg, 1939, 39: 323-52.—Friedl, E. Beitrag zur Osteochondritis dissecans des Hiiftkopfes. Rontgenpraxis, 1936 8- 16-21 —Gold, A. M. Osteochondritis dissecans of the femoral'head. Bull. Hosp. .bunt Dis, N. Y„ 1940, 1: 30-6 — Gold, E. Ueber das Vorkommen und das klinische Bild der dissezierenden Osteochondritis am Hiiftgelenk. Deut. Zschr. Chir, 1930. 225: 296-307.—Crasser, C. H. Kleiner Beitrag zur Osteochondritis dissecans des Hiiftgelenkes. Acta radiol. cancer, bohem, 1939, 2: 3-6.—Lange, M. Zwei Falle von doppelseitiger Osteochondritis dissecans (Konig) der Fcmur- kopfe. Zschr. orthop. Chir, 1929, 51: 269-81.—Mouchet, A. Osteochondrite dissequante de la hanche (maladie de Koenig) Presse med, 1935, 43: 1483. Also Gazz. osp, 1936, 57: 400- 2.—Moulonguet, P. Osteochondrite dissequante de la hanche (maladie de Koenig de la tete femorale) Bull. Soc. nat. chir. Par, 1932, 58: 1471-84. ------ L'osteochondrite dissequante de la hanche; ses relations avec l'arthrite deformante de la hanche. Rapp. Congr. internat. rhumat. (1932) 1934, 3. Congr, 339-47. ------ Evolution post-operatoire d'une osteo- chondrite; dissequante de la hanche. Bull. Soc. nat. chir. Par, 1934, 60: 466.—Miiller. W. Ein Beitrag zur Osteo- chondritis dissecans des Hiiftgelenkes (das Bild des intra- artikularen Dekubitus der knochernen Epiphyse) Zbl. Chir, 1939, 66: 486-9.—Outland. T. A, it Flood, J. M. Osteo- chondritis dissecans acetabuli. Am. J. Surg, 1936, 33: 276- 84 —Radicke, K. Operationsergebnisse bei Osteochondritis dissecans. Beitr. klin. Chir , 1930, 150: 121-9.—Raeder. G. [Case of congenital subluxatio coxae with circumscribed necrosis of the epiphysis in head of the femur (osteochondritis dissecans)] Norsk, mag. laegevid., 1935, 96: [Forh. kir. foren. Oslo] 24.—Ruiz Moreno, M. Osteo-condritis de la cadera; consideraciones sobre 10 casos. Actas Congr. nac. cir, B. Air, 1930, 2. Congr, 2: 1247-63.—Schorcher. Osteochondritis dissecans des Hiiftgelenkes und Unfall. Arch, orthop. UnfaU- chir, 1937-38, 38: 326-6.—Simon, L. [Osteochondritis dis- secans] Orv. hetil, 1940, 84: meliek.. 87.—Storen, H. Osteo- chondritis dissecans in den Huftgelenken als konstitutioiielles Leiden, sowie ein Fall eines tardiven Demarkationsprozesses nach Fractura colU femoris. Acta chir. scand, 1934, 74: 491- 512, 7 pl.—Vails, J, & Ottolenghi, C. E. Osteocondritis disecante de la cabeza femoral. Bol. Soc. cir. B. Aires, 1933, 17: 74-80. Also Rev. ortop. traumat, B. Air, 1932-33, 2: 465-72. --- Osteomyelitis. See also Hip-joint, Osteomyelitis. Petit, P. P. *Traitement precoce de l'osteo- myeiite aigue de la hanche de l'adolescent. HOp. 8? Par., 1934. Ziehm, K. *Osteomyelitis der Huftgegend [Greifswald] 35p. 8° Artern a. Kyffh., 1933. Bercovich, A, & Solari, J. M. Osteomielitis de la cadera y artritis aguda. Prensa med. argent, 1937, 24: 1167-72.— Bufalini, M. Osteomielite acuta dell'anca. Chir. org. movim, 1938-39,24:425-38. ------ Indirizzo terapeutico nell'osteo- mielite dell'anca. Arch. Soc. ital. chir. (1938) 1939.45:693-5 — Demelenne, F. Contribution a l'etude de l'osteomyeiite aigue de la hanche. Rev. chir. Par, 1939, 77: 547-61.—Funck- Brentano, P. L'osteomyeiite aigue de la hanche. Bull, med. Par, 1937. 51: 491-504.—Guilleminet, M, & Creyssel, J. OsteomyeUtede la hanche fistulisee dans la vessie; radiographic apres injection intravesical de lipiodol. J. urol. med. Par, 1927, 24: 525-8.—Magrassi, A. L'osteomielite acuta dell'anca nei lattante. Lattante, 1939, 10: 99-108.—Menard. L. Ost.eomyeiite de la hanche. Ann. anat. path. Par, 1936, 13: 903.—Ozerov, A.D. [Therapy of chronic gun-shot osteomyelitis of the hip] Vest, khir, 1926, 7: No. 20, 76-81.—Papin, E. Osteomveiite des 2 bandies a 9 ans d'intervalle. Bordeaux chir, 1932, 3: 481.—Soeur. R. Osteomyeiite de la hanche. Rev. chir. Par, 1931, 69: 377-428, 14 pl. --- Paralysis. Barneville, C. *Du traitement des hanches ballantes paralytiques et en particulier de leur traitement par la pelvitrochanteropexie myo- plastique a la soie. 87p. 8? Par., 1935. Beaufils, R. M. E. H. *La hanche paraly- tique en orthopedie [Paris] 222p. 8? Blois, 1936. El-Dick, M. I. *Traitemcnt chirurgical de la hanche paralytique en flexion; operation de Campbell. 51p. 8° Lyon, 1937. Albee, F. H. Elongation of kinesiological lever at hip in partial paralysis. Med. Rec, N. Y, 1939, 150: 349-51. -----Surgical elongation of the kinesiologic hip lever in partial paralysis. J. Internat. Coll. Surgeons, 1940, 3: 512-8.— Boppe. Pelvitrochanteropexie k la soie pour hanche bal ante paralytique. Mem. Acad, chir. Par, 1936, 62: 124o. Colonna. P. C. Proposed operation for abductor paralysis ol the hip. J. M. Soc. N. Jersey, 1926, 23: 177— lushchenko, 227475—vol. 7, 4th sekies----43 V. A. [Functional devices in slight paralysis of the hip joint] In bborn. trud. posv. G. I. Turner (Leningrad. Voen. med. akad. Kirov) Leningr, 1938, 273-84.—Mathaly. Paralvsie du femoral ant6rieur d'origine traumatique. Rev. vet , Toulouse, 1923, 75: 83-6.—Samson, J. E. Aponevropexie femorale dans la hanche paralytique. Lyon chir, 1938, 35: 641-53.—Thomsen, W. Zur Statik und Mechanik der ge- sunden und gelahmten Hufte; uber die Verschiebung des Beckens beziehungsweise des Hiiftkopfes der gelahmten Seite in der Frontalebene. Zschr. orthop. Chir, 1934-35, 62: 275-301. ---- Surgery. See also Hip-joint, Surgery. Dyas. F. G. Reconstruction of the hip. Proc. Inst. M. Chicago, 1934, 10: 130.—Felsenreich. F. Operative Behand- lung von Epiphvsenlosungen der Hufte und lateralen Schenkel- lialsbriichen auf operativem Wege. Wien. klin. Wschr, 1935, 48: 906.—Graber-Duvernay, J. [Indications, contra-indica- tions and results of Duvernay's operation] Hospitalstidende, 1935, 78: [Dansk. kir. selsk. forh.] 31-4. Also Lvon chir, 1935, 32: 182-92.—Massart, R. Le forage des epiphyses et l'endoscopie intra-osseuse. Bull. Soc. chir. Paris, 1935, 27: 264-76.—Nelson, C. A. Operative treatment of fractures of the neck of the femur and epiphyseal separation of the head of the femur in the dog. North Am. Vet, 1941, 22: 557-9.— Poissonnier, M, & Calot. Sur le traitement des decollements epiphvsaires et des fractures du col du femur. J. sc. med. Lille, 1920, 38: pt 2, 265-73.—Wagner, I, C, & Rizzo, P. C. Stabilization of the hip bv the transplantation of the anterior thigh muscles. J. Bone Surg, 1936, 18: 180-2.—Whitman. R. The Whitman reconstruction operation. Ibid, 1939, 21: 1051. ---- Tumor. Bed ere, H. Enorme fibromo calcifie decouvert k l'occasion d'un examen radiographique pour fracture de la hanche. J. radiol. electr, 1937, 21: 324.—Chonukov, G. [Exarticulation of lower limbs in sarcoma of the hip] Vrach. delo, 1926, 9: 1383-6.—Meerovich, L. V. [Case of congenital sarcoma of the hip] Khirurgia, Moskva, 1938, No. 7-8, 120-3.—Milian & Perin, L. Histiocytome de la hanche. Bull. Soc. fr. derm. syph, 1933, 40: 555-7.—Monjardino, J. Fibroma kystico da coxa. Rev. brasil. med. farm.. 1925. 1: 126-31, pl.—Sarcoma of hip in relation to trauma; U. S. Circuit Court. J. Am. M. Ass, 1937, 109: 1606.—Schie, E. [Case of synovioma in the region of the hip-joint] Nord. med, 1940, 7: 1538-41.— Schmidt. F. R. Adenoma sudoriferum. Arch. Derm. Syph, Chic, 1940, 42: 203. HIP-BONE. See also Hip, Hip-joint; also Acetabulum; Ilium; Ischium; Pelvis; Pubis. Dupuy de Frenelle. Anatomie squeiettique de la region operatoire. Techn. chir. Par, 1937, 29: 100.—Horiuti, T. Untersuchungen uber das Hiiftbein der Aino. Jap. J. M. Sc, 1941, 9: Proc. Anat, 34.—Pratje. A. Ueber die postembryonal Entwicklung des Hiiftbeins; nach Untersuchungen an lebenden Menschen. Zschr. Morph. Anthrop, 1934, 34: 321-42. ---- Disease. See also names of general diseases of the skeleton. Desgrtjelles, A. M. *Sur un cas d'exostoses osteogeniquesde la hanche. 45p. 8? Par., 1928. Brailsford, J. F. Bone changes simulating tuberculosis or tumour with special reference to osteochondritis. Lancet, Lond 1935 1: 1487-92.—Curutchet, P. D. Hidatidosis del hueso'coxal.' Dia med, B. Air, 1934-35, 7: 188-91.—Grenet, H, & Delalande, J. Insuffisance hypophysaire et lesions osseuses de la hanche. Bull. Soc. pediat. Paris, 1927, 25: 2g]_4.—Painter, C. F. Osteomyelitis of the innominate bone; reasons for rarity of location; methods of repair, operative and otherwise J. Am. M. Ass, 1926, 86: 341-6.—San Miguel, J. Quiste hidatico del hueso coxal. Prensa med. argent, 1934-35, 21: 507; 546. ---- Tumor. See also Hip, Tumor; Hip-joint, Tumor. Alustiza F & Scara. P. Sarcoma osteogenico de la cadera. Sem mid.'li. Air, 1939, 46: pt 2, 895-900— Carteret, Dillen- secer & Bertrand, P. Volumineux osteo-sarcome coxo-femoral o-auche. .1. radiol. electr, 1938. 22: .V.8.-Dj0rup, F [Tumor of the ischium treated by interilioab.lominal amputation and extirpation] Hospitalstidende. 1932 75: 1467-75.—Fagge. C H Sarcoma of acetabulum mistaken for tuberculous hip. Brit. J. Surg, 1935-36, 23: 671-3.-Frank, L. Osteosarcoma of hip- case report with comments. Internat. J. Surg 1927, 40- 187-9 —Ouelette, C. J. Osteosarcoma of the hip (a case report) Clin. M. & S, 1936, 43: 555. Sforzi. A. Istoria di ammitazione della coscia sinistra per osteosarcoma. Arch. sc med fis toscane (1837-38) 1840, 1: 447-53.-Votta, E. A. HIP-BONE 074 HIP-JOINT Procesos ••eudotumorahs del hue so coxal. Sein. m6d, B. Air, l'.t35. 42: 1001- 5.- Young. J. K. Disarticulation of the hip- joint foi periosteal «nrcoma. Ann. Surg, 1922, 76: 115. HIPI S. F. S.. & FISHKH. B. E. Druggist's art of manufacturing; a concise and practical treatise on the manufacture of perfume, toilet articles, proprietary remedies and miscellaneous preparations. 5G5p. S? Chic. [n. pub.] 1892. HIP-JOINT. Hakac-. G. [Bony til- in the hip-jointl Orv. hetil, 1939, 83: 7ss, .iju—r)e Santo. I). A, A: Colonna, P. C. Embryolo2\ of tin- 1 ip joint; prelimiii-ny obsen ations. Arch. Surg.. 1939 39: I4.s 5ii. Duvernay \- Parent. Note sui ipielipio- modi- fications structurally v:n|iie. Lyon chir, 1927 24: 140-9.- Cesclevich, A. M. [4'.- i •> of innervation of the capsule of the coxo-femoral articulation' Tr. Acad. mil. med. Kiroff, 1935, 2: 222-32.— Cickler. Dei Einfluss der Iluftmuskulatur auf die Konfiguration des Kopfes und der Pfanne. Zbl. Chir.. 1935. 62: 2743.------- Der Einfluss d< r Muskulatur auf die Konliguiation des Huftgelenks. Verh. Deut. orthop. Ges. i 193-1) 1935, 30. Kongr.. 82 90. Also Beitr. klin. Chir, 1930. 163: Kit). — Cickler. II. Einige- iiber die Beziehungen zwi-chen l-'ii-- und Hiiftgelenk. Zsclir. Orthop, 1937. 66: 305-77.- Hukumolo, N. Beitrag zur Anatomie des lliiflirolenkes. mit Berucksichtigung ihrer Be- deutung fur die Chirurgie. Fukuoka acta m. d, 1936, 20: 53.—Jansen, M. [Anatomy of a normal liip-j int in relation to clinical symptoms] Ned. tschr. geneesk. 1934. 7H: 1913.— Kreuz. Das anatomische und rontgenologische Bild des Ansatzes der Huftgelenkskapsel. Verb. Deut. orthop. Ges. (1925) 1920. 2(1. Kongr, 153-6 (Discussion] 172.—Morville. P. On the anatomv and pathology of the hip-joint. Acta orthop scand.. 1930, 7: 107-42. — Sadovsky, D. M. ]Innervation of the capsule of tin hip-joint] Vest, khir, 1933. 31: 100-3. ---- Actinomycosis. Ifub.iin i. P. [Actinomycosis of hip-joint] Orvoskepzes, 1935, 25: der. kulonf. (T. Vercbfly l-'cstschr.) 260-73, pl. ---- Ankylosis. Alivisatos, C. X. *Le traitement opcratoire des ankyloses non tuberculeuses dc la hanche chez l'adulte (etude experimentale et de thera- peutique chirurgicale) 202p. 8? Par., 1933. Abbott, I.eR. ('.. & Jostes, F. A. A simple method for cor- rection of deformity in bonv ankylosis of the hip joint. Sui" Gyn. Obst., 1920, 12: 274-82.- Adams. A. O. A method for the pro-operative determination of the l.e-t functional position for an ankylosed hip; a preliminary report. Ibid., 1931, 52: 2(il -5.—Bosch Arana, G. Tratamiento de las anonilosis de la cadera en fuerte flexirin. Bol. Soc. eir. B. Abes, 1927, 11: 225-34. Also Sem. med, B. Air, 1927. 34: 1" II. Charry. R. Resultat du traitement orthopedique et chirurgical d un malade presentaut une ankylose en attitude vieiinse cie la hanche, consecutive a one atteinte d'o-ieono elite. Bull. Soc. chir. PaiK 1934. 26: 83-9.—Cokkinis, A. J. Ankylosis of the hip joint; etiology. S. Mary's Hosp. Gaz, Lond, 1931, 37: 92-5.—D dberg, I. A. [Subtrochanteric osteotomy in ank\loMS and contractures of the hip-joim] Ortop. travmat, 1937. 11: 14 24.—Dupuy de Irenelle Doit-on tenter de mobiliser operatoirenient la hanche d'un malade atteint de maladie ankylosante des 2 membies mfi'i ieurs'.' Techn chir Par, 1934, 2f»: 247. ------- Doit-on < hoieher k mobiliser par one arthroplastie la hanche ankvlo-ce d'un coxalgique irnc'ri depuis de non.I.reuse- annee-.-.' 11 <-l..-t. med. acta, 1935-36, 2: 128 31.-Duvoir, M. L evaluation de l'ank\ lose de la hanche. Ann. mod. leg.. 1933. 13: 2-id. -Gomez, O. I... & Taubenschlag, H. La osteotomia sublro.-;intei-iana para coiregir las aiuiuilo.si- viciosas de la artieulacion de la cadera. Prensa med. ai'n-ni 1941. 28: pt 2, 1667-73.— Klapp, R. Ueber die op-rathe Mobili-Kiung des Huftgelenks. Chirurg, 1928-29, 1:20-3.— Kuhns, J. C A chair for bilateral ankylosis of the hip joint. J. Bone Surz.cr, A. Late results in a case of ai throplasly of l.oih hip joints for painful ankylosing arthritB. .1. Lancet | 193.-.. 55: 515. Also Minnesota AI.. 1935, 18: 553.- Sol6, U. Anquilosis de cadera on position viciosa: osteolotnia y euniriuh | por el metodo a cielo abierto. Bol. Soe. cir. B. Aires, 1928 m- 5-14, 3 pl. Also Sem. med.. B. Air, 1928, 35: 1111 ti. Sorrel. E. Coxalgie ayant entratn6 un raccourcissement de II centimetres; marche excellente grftce ft l'ankylose en foitc abduction du niciiilue. Mem. Acad, chi'. Bar, 1939, 65: 851.- Spitzy, II. Miiftmobilisienmg bei Bechlerew. Zsclir. orthop. <"hir, 1933. 59: 225 33. Thomson, W. Leber das (leben mit Vcisteifung beider 11 iif I •/olenke. Arch, orthop UnfaUchir, 1933-34, 34: 280-91. - - Dopp, Ucnge Ankylosen und Kontrakturen der Hiiftgelcnke als Uis.nhiii von Gehstorungen. Ibid, 1939 40, 40: 183 5- Topa, I', lV Caramzulesco, D. L'osteotomie sous-tronchanlei ienne dans les ankyloses vicieuses dc 1 'ai lieu la lion coxolemoiale. Ilruxelles med, 1930-37, 17: 1126 :>'.. Vreden. R. R. (\nkylosis of hip-joint treated bv p-emlm I In o.is t Koenig's operation)] Vest, khir, 1926, 8: No. 2 1. ',9 12. Wallurcn. (i. [On arthro- plastia coxae and osteotomia femoiis wit b nnk\ lo-od contrac- ture of the hip-joint] Nord. med, 1939, 2: 1417. ---- Arthrokatadysis. Cary, N. A, & Barnard, L. Arthrokatadysis of the hip joint, .1. Bone Surg, 1932, 14: 687-9.—Gellman, M. Arthro- katadysis of the hip joint. South. M. J, 1931, 27: 215-9.— I.evinthal, D. H, & Wolin, I. Arthiokntndvsis of the hip joint Radiology, 1935, 25: 5S0 -5.-- Reed. F. N. A ease of arthro- katadysis of the hip joint. .1. Bone Sum, 1933, 15: 802.— Srougall. S. H. Ai t hrokaPuh sis of the hip joint. Med. J, Australia, 1931, 2: 388 90. ---- Calcification. Steger, A. * Klinik und Behandlung para- articuliirer Kalkablagerungen am Hiiftgelenk [Konigsberg] 17p. 8? Elbing, 1927. Duvoir, M, Pollet, L. fet al] Calcifications ou osseleta p'riarticulaires de la hanche? Ann. med. h'g, 1938, 18: 461- 70.--Dyes, O. Ein vei kalktes Seiikung.^h-'inialoni. Arch. orthop. UnfaUchir, 1931 35, 35: 189-92.- Goldenberg, R. R, & Levenlhal, (i. S. Su|irat roehanti-iie calcification. .1. Bone Surg, 1930, 18: 205 1 1. Mauclaire. Calcifications et ossi- fications peiiatticulaiies et osselets perieota loidiens et intra- eotvloidiens de la hanche. Ann. med. leg, 1938, 18: 471-9.— Steu'emann, H. Leber ein wenig beachtetes Krankheitsbild am Hiiftgelenk. Med. Welt, 1927, 1: 202-4. ---- Chondromatosis. Chandler, F. A. Chondromatosis of the hip joint. Am. J. Dis. Child, 1941, 62: 085.—Fredet. P. Osteochondromatose de la hancbe. Bull. Soc. nat. chir. Bar, 1928, 54: 1079-83.— Hertz, R. Chondromatosis ai tioulationis coxa. Acta orthop. scand, 1930. 1: 356-8.—Jalet, J. (isleo-ehondromatose ou arthnte chronique de la hanche-.' Bull. Soc. radiol. med. France, 1937, 25: 442-5.- Kaiser, H. (:hondromatose des Hiiftgdciiks. Wien. med. Wschr, 1928, 78: 4.32. -Kartal, S. IChond.omatosis of the hip .jointl Cas. lek. cesk, 1934, 73: 04 -9, 2 pl.— Lehner, A. Zur Schleimbeutel- und < ielonko-teo- choiidiomatose. Schweiz. med. Wschr, 1937. 67: 031-0 - Nilsson, F. Kin Fall von Chondi oinatose des HufO'elenkcs Arch. klin. Chir, 1927, 144: 458-70. Sato, N. Kin 'fall von im Hiifigelenk und benachbarten Schleimbeutel entstandener Osteochondromatosis. Okayama igakkai zasshi, 1939, 51: 91o. -Valsecchi, R, & Pierangeli, L. La eondromatosi arti- colare dell'anca. Arch. ital. chir, 1938, 54: 805-23. ---- Contracture. Dittrich, F. K. G. *Ueber die Behandlung der in Flexions- und Adduktionsstellung ausge- hcilten Coxitis. 8p. 8? [Lpz.] 1922. Genscher [J.] W. *L'eber einen Fall von angeborener Huftbeugekontraktur [Leipzig] 27p. 23'/2cm. [Zeulenroda, 1937] Azbeleva, O. N. [Operation of spinotomv in paralvtic contractures of the hip-joint] In Shorn, truri. posv. G. I. ■Turner (Leningrad. Voen. med. akad. Kirov) Leningr, 1938, 321-4. pl.—Burman, M. S. An operative procedure for the correction of external-rotation contracture of the hip. J. Bone Surg, 1935, 17: 1028-30. Also Am. .1. Surg, 1939, 43: 414— Fnedlander, F. Die Gesetze der entziindlichen Celeuks- kontraktur, erlautert am Huftgelenke. Deut. Zschr. Chir, 1926, 196: 121-93.—Haberler, G. Ueber einen exzessiv hochgradigen Fall doppelsei tiger Huftkontrakturen und dessen HIP-JOINT 675 HIP-JOINT Behandlung; nebst einem kurzen LTeberblick der an der Klinik in einschlagigen Fallen geubten Behaudlungsprinzipien. Wien. klin. Wschr, 1930, 43: 967-70.—Lamy, L. Coxa flecta; traitement par la reinfraction. Paris chir, 1926, 18: 121.— Loeffler, F. Zur Behandlung von Adduktionskontrakturen des Beines bei nicht versteiftem Hiiftgelenk. Zbl. Chir, 1931, 58: 2242-4.—Mutel. Du danger de l'hypercorrection de l'adduc- tion de la hanche par osteotomie sous-trochanterienne dans la coxalgie guerie. Rev. med. Nancy, 1937, 65: 27-9.—Speed, J. S. End results in transference of the crest of the ilium for flexion contracture of the hip. J. Bone Surg, 1928. 10: 202- 19.—Stanishev, A. Zur Beseitigung der Femurverkurzung bei Huftkontrakturen. Deut. med. Wschr, 1926, 52: 628-30 — Tavernier, M. Hanche k ressaut douloureuse avec contracture en attitude vicieuse. Lvon chir, 1937, 34: 91-3.—Thomsen, W. Zur manuellen gymnastischen Behandlung der Beuge- und Streckkontraktiiren der Huftgelenke. Zschr. orthop. Chir, 1932, 56: 278-82. --- Cotyloid cavity. Bellocq, G. *Le traitement des fractures recentes de la cavite cotylo'ide avec penetration intrapelvienne de la tete femorale. 46p. 24cm. Par., 1939. Martel, E. *Etude radiologique de la cavite cotylo'ide normale de l'adulte. 62p. 8? Par., 1936. Mathtjrin, L. *Les luxations secondaires de la hanche dans les fractures parcellaires du sourcil cotyloidien. 4Gp. 25cm. Bordeaux, 1937. Bastos Ausart, M. Dos casos de hundimiento del fondo de la cavidad cotiloidea. Progr. clin, Madr, 1914, 4: 32-44, pl.— De Luca, G. Distacco dell'os cotiloideum superius. Chir. org. movim, 1936-37, 22: 234-8— Logroscino, D, & Dotti, E. Vascolarizzazione e patologia della cavita cotiloide. Ibid, 285-308.—Logrdscino. D, & Enrico. Vascolarizzazione e patologia della caviti cotiloidea. Arch. ital. chir, 1935, 41: 993.—Moiroud, P. La reduction des fractures du cotyle avec penetration intrapelvienne de la tete femorale est possible k l'aide des tables orthopediques. Presse med, 1936, 44 : 748.— Nadein, A. P. IFractures of the cotyloid cavity] Khirurgia, Moskva, 1939, No. 10, 109-12.—Patel & Violet. Fracture du sourcil cotyloidien avec ascension de la tete femorale, coincidant avee une fracture du membre inferieur. Lyon chir, 1937, 34: 84-6.—Perricone. F. Sulla coxalgia cotiloidea. Chir. org. movim, 1934-35. 19: 331-42.—Rigal. Fracture de la cavite cotylolde avec penetration de la tete femorale dans le bassin. Lyon chir, 1939, 36: 320-2.—Roederer, C. La coxalgie consecutive aux osteites du sourcil cotyloidien. Presse med, 1929 37: 1295-7. —Roger, .1. P. Coxalgies k debut cotyloidien. Laval med, 1937. 2: 247-51.—Vincent, G, & Senellart. Fractures de la cavite cotyloide. J. sc. med. Lille, 1930, 48: pt 2, 486-9. --- Coxa magna. Ferguson, A. B, & Howorfh, M. B. Coxa magna; a condi- tion of the hip related to coxa plana. J. Am. M. Ass, 1935, 104: 808-12. --- Coxa plana. See Hip, Osteochondritis deformans. --- Coxa valga. Renner, M. F. C. *Die Subluxatio coxae congenita und ihre Beziehung zur Arthritis deformans coxae mit Berucksichtigung der Coxa valga luxans. 62p. 8? Bresl., 1926. Studemeister, A. *Coxa valga luxans [Mar- burg] 27p. 24cm. Berl., 1936. Also Beitr. klin. Chir, 1936, 164: Baumann, J. Ueber Pfannendachplastik bei Coxa valga luxans und nicht einrenkbarer angeborener Hiiftluxation. Med. Khn, Berl, 1936, 32: 1182-4.—Block, W. Ueber Coxa valga luxans mit wechselnder Koploinstellung; die schlotternde Hufte. Arch. klin. Chir, 1923, 123: 704-15.—Bulow-Hangen. [Coxa valgoplana; roentgen demonstration] Norsk, mag. laegevid, 1936. 97: [Forh. kir. foren. Oslo] 47-51, 2 pl.— Ettorre, E. Sui rapporti fra coxa valga e osteocondrite. 1 oh- clinico, 1927, 34: sez. chir, 58-67.—Garrido-Lestache, J. Coxa valga bilateral (nota clinica) Pediat. espan, 1927 16: 357-9 pl —Gourdon, J. Coxa-valga et coxa-recta. Bordeaux chir, 1930, 1: 308.—Haas, S. L. Coxa valga. In Cyclop. Med. (Piersol-Bortz) Phila, 1939, 3: 49.—Hackenbroch, M. Coxa valga. Erg. Chir. Orthop, 1927, 20: 71-130—lacobovici, I, & Jianu, St [Coxa valga] Rev. chir, Bucur, 1929, 21: 119-42.—Jansen, M. [Coxa valga and its causes] Ned. tschr geneesk, 1927, 71: pt 2, 232. -Landres, Z. A. [Coxa valga] Ortop. travmat, 1935, 9: 82-96.—Lapeyre, N. C, & Mourgue- Molines, E. Coxa valga et coxite de la puberte. Rev. orthop. Par. 1928, 3. ser, 15: 232-41.—Lindemann. Zur Pathogenese der Coxa valga. Verh. Deut. orthop. Ges. (1933) 1934, 28. Kongr, 329-36.------Die Coxa valga bei der kongenitalen Muskelatonie. Ibid. (1935) 1936, 30. Kongr, 401-12 — Lindemann. K. Das Wachstum des Schenkelhalses bei der sogenannten Entlastungs-Coxa-valga. Deut. Z.schr. Chir. 1930, 228: 249-60.—Massabuau & Guibal. A propos de la pathologie des hanches en porte-&-faux; 2 observations de coxa-valga. Bull. Soe. sc. med. biol. Montpelier, 1920-27, 8: 83-9TJ.—Massart, R, & Vidal-Naquet, G. Les coxa valga. In their Prat, orthop. Par, 1938, 528.—Mosebach, H. Beitrag zur Entstehung der Coxa valga. Zsehr. Orthop, 1935-36, 64: 281-7.—Muller, W. Die Entstehung von Coxa valga durch Epiphysenverschiebung. Beitr. klin. Chir, 1926, 137: 148-64. ------Latent verlaufende angeborene Coxa valga luxans, als Ursache einer tvpischen Spaterkrankung des Hiiftgelenkes. Ibid, 1927, 1.39: 464-83.—Musil, V. [Coxa valga luxans, its clinical and etiological role in the pathology of hip diseases] Cas. 16k. eesk, 1928, 67: 971-4; 1015.—Pitzen. Coxa valga adolescenfium. Verh. Deut. orthop. Ges. (1935) 1930, 30. Kongr, 389-401.—Pusch. Coxa valga luxans contracta mit einigen allgemeiuen Betrachtungen zum Kapitel Osteochondri- tis. Ibid. (1927) 1928, 22. Kongr, 179-86.—Rocher, H. L, & Rioux, G. Un cas de coxa valga bilaterale congenitale avec subluxation du cote gauche. J. med. Bordeaux, 1926, *56: 759.—Scheuermann. H. Coxa valga caused by a separation of the epiphysis. Acta orthop. scand, 1930, 1: 178-82. Also Hospitalstidende, 1931, 74: [Dansk radiol. selsk. forh.] 8-11.—Simons, B. Zur Entstehung der Coxa valga luxans. Arch, orthop. UnfaUchir, 1931, 30: 260-9.------ Unter- suchungen zur Entstehung der Coxa valga insbesondere der Entlastungs- und Adductoren-Coxa valga. Ibid, 1932-33, 32: 32-60.—Sommer, R. Coxa valga und Steilheit des Beckens in ihrer Beziehung zur Luxatio coxae. Deut. Zschr. Chir, 1924, 187: 375-8L -Storck, H. Coxa valga, ein Beitrag zur Frage der den Knochen formenden Kriifte. Arch, orthop. UnfaUchir, 1932-33.32: 133-224.------Coxa valga. Verh. Deut. orthop. Ges. (1935) 1936, 30. Kongr, 345-01.—Wilhelm, R. Die Entstehung einer Coxa valga luxans (eine seltene klinische Beobachtung) Deut. Zschr. Chir, 1931, 232: 462-6. ---- Coxa vara. Kaeser, A. *Coxa vara [Heidelberg] 41p. 8? Niirnb., 1930. Barr, J. S. Congenital coxa vara. Arch. Surg, 1929, 18: 1909-19.—Braeunig, K. Coxa vara im Kindesalter. Zbl. Chir, 1935, 62: 1475-81.—Burns, B. H, & Ellis, V. H. Adoles- cent coxa vara. In their Recent Advances Orthop, Lond, 1937, 125-33.—Ellis. V. H. Adolescent coxa vara. Lancet, Lond, 1935. 1: 1440 2— Fairbank. H. A. T. Unusual case of congenital coxa vara. Proc. R. Soc. M, Lond, 1926, 20: 237.------Infantile or cervical coxa vara. Tn Robert Jones Birthday Vol, Oxf, 1928, 225-41.- Gelding, C. Congenital coxa vara and the short femur. Proc. R. Soc. M, Bond, 1938- 39. 32: Sect. Orthop, 641-6.— Gratsiansky, V. P. [Coxa vara congenita] Ortop. travmat, 1939, 13: No. 6, 33-40.—Gray, C. Adolescent coxa vara. Mag. London School M. Women, 1939- 41 3: 90-5, 2 pl.—Guermonprez, F. Coxa vara unilat6rale. .1 sc. med. Lille, 1924, 42: 01-4.—Haas, S. L. Coxa vara. In Cyclop. Med. years. Tr. M. Soc. London, 1935, 58: 31.—Zadek, I. Congenital coxa vara. Arch, Surg, 1935, 30: 62-102.—Zalewski, A. [Case of congeni- HIP-JOINT 676 HIP-JOINT tal, bilateral coxa-vara] Chir. narz. ruchu, 1934, 7: 215-28, pl.- '/aremba, J. Congenital coxa vara; report of a case. J. Bone Suig, 19.35, 17: 450-2. ---- Coxa vara: Diagnosis. Bade. A. Zui Abgrenzung der verschiedenen Formen von Coxa Mini. Zsehr. orthop. Chir, 1933. 59: 53-75.- Ducroquet, R, ix- Crolcau. L. Radiogi aphie de profi! du col femoral dans la coxa vara de !'adolescence. Ann. anat. path. Par, 1933. 10: 799 S03.- Crat.-ianskv. V. P. [Roentgen diagnosis, course and pathogenesis oi coxa vara in children] In Shorn, trud. posv. G. I. Turner (Leningrad. Voen. med. akad. Kirov) Leningr, 1938. 327-46.— Krukenberg. H. Zur Differential- diagnose zwischen angeborener I Ii.l i g<-lenk*luxn i ion und Coxa vaia congenita. Zbl. Chir, 1!':!ii. .7: 3108.—Lindemann. K. Die Fiuhdiagnose der Coxa vaia adoleM entium. Ibid, 1931 fil : 887 90. Mever-Hurgdorff. Friihdiagnose der Coxa vara. Ibid, 1935, 62: 2Smi 8. ---- Coxa vara, epiphyseal. Dockteh, A. * Beitrag zur Frage der trau- matischen Epiphvsenlosung am Sehenkelhals. 28p. S? Bonn, 1937. Dvmixil, J. Contribution a l'etude du pronostic, de la pathogenic et du traitement de la coxa vara epiphysaire des adolescents. 105p. 8? Par., 1927. Eggeh, J. *Ueber Epiphyseolysis capitis femoris und Coxa vara adolescentitun [Zurich] 29p. 8? Bigge-Ruhr, 1<)36. i'ltisixc, G. *Epiphyseolysis capitis femoris forhiilhinde till coxa vara. 167p. 8? Lund, 1926. Kliem, G. *Ueber traumatische Epiphysen- losungen am oberen Femurcnde und deren Folge- erscheinungen. 17p. 23D<-m. Lpz., 1936. Kratzert, (!. *Die Frsache und Behandlung der ttchenkelkopfepiphvsenlosung. 29p. 20'^cni. Konigsb., 1937. Yohgand.iis, J. *Le decollement epiphysaire du femur au cours dc l'osteomyeiite de la hanche. 44p. N° Par., 1925. Adams, J. D. Mechanics and reduction of displaced upper femoral epiphysis. N. England J. M, 1934, 210: 178-80.— Iiadglc>. <'. F. Displacement of the upper femoral epiphysis; summary of L»7 cases. J. Am. M. Ass, 1929, 92: 355-9.— BalensHiiir, I. Femoral osteochondritis of adolescents and sequelae; epiphyseal separation of the hip Surg. Gvn. Obst 1926. 43: 604-14. lit r.lzon,. P. G. K. Should reposition of epiphyseolvsis capitis femoi's scand, 1931-32. 2: 331- 'i. femoris. Ibid, 1939, 10: 27S-S of the end results of 57 cases - f -I ,7. Bone Surg, 1935, 17: 179-.1 epifisario tiaumatico oste'ueo be inaile'.' Acta orthop. -■ I-'.piph.\ seolysis capitis Hroirden. W. F. Review ■d upper femoral epiphysis. Camera. U. 11 distaceo -tremitu superiore del femore. Arch, on op., Milano, 1930. 46: 1019-27. -Camitz, H. Leber die Behandlung der traumatisehen Epiphysenablosimg am Caput femoris. Acta chir. scand, 1929, 05: 82-95, 6 pl.— Dunlop. E. F. Slipped upper femoral epiphysis, with a report on a case treated l.v skeletal traction. Austral. X. Zealand J Surg, 1939-40, 9: 279 87— Eikenbary, C. F, & LeCocq, J. V. Separation of the upper femoral epiphysis; summary of 10 cases. Northwest M, 1931, 30: 22-5.------Separation of the upper femoral epiphysis: -utnmaiv of 14 ca-.es (18 hip=) West. .1. Surg, 1932, 40: 432 7.- Felsenrich, F. Osteo- synthese frischer und veraltetei Epipln senlo.Mingen der Hufte Chirurg. 1930, 8: 247-51.- Felsenreich, F. Die operative Behandlung fii-cher und verabeiei Epipliy-,eiiloaungen der Hufte. Arch. Kiinb-th, 1938. 114: 227 3o— Ferguson, A. B, A- Howorth. M. B. Slipping of the upper femoial epiphysis' a study of 70 cases. .1. Am. M. Ass, 1931. 97: 1807-72. Also repr.—Field. G. C. Traumatic separation of epiphyses of head of femur (with a report on 3 ta=e-'i Brit. ,1. Ri.diol iy>9 n ser, 2: 297-300. 2 pl.—Friedrich, H. Ueber Endausgam'e von Huftgelenkserkrankungen mit besondoioi BerucksicliugunL' der Coxa vara epiphysaria. Arch. klin. Chir, 1931, 167: 65 ------ Coxa vara epiphysarea: Yei-l.-.uf. Behandlung, Endaus- gfinge. Aetiologie. Ibid, 168: 132-62.—Fusari, A. Contiibuto alio studio del distaceo epifisario superiore del femore da trauma ostetrico. Gior. Accad. med. Torino, 1931, 94: 54-8.—Giitig C. Die Epiphvsenlosung im Sehenkelhals bei Jugendlichen' lortsch. Rontgenstrahl, I'.-.'iS 57: 391.------& Herzog, a! Zur Pathogenese der Epiphyscnlosung des Schenkelkop'fe--' Ibid, 1937. 55: 593.------Die Epiphysenlosung im Sehen- kelhals bei Jugendlichen. Beitr. klin. Chir, 1937, 166: 85-95 ~ ,,. ,Dle ->'""i|ie Epiphysenlosung im Sehenkelhals bei Jugendlichen. Med. Klin, Berl, 1938, 34: 049 -51.— Gutierrez A. Consideraciones sobre un caso de desprendimiento epifLsa-io del femur izquierdo con coxa-vara traumatica secundaria Dia med, B. Air 1920-30 2: 779.—Hass. Zur Behandlung der Coxa vaia infolge Epiphyseolysis capitis femoris. Verh. Deut. orthop. Ges. (1929) 1930, 24. Kongr, 61. Haas. S. I, Slipping epiphysis of the head of the femur, epiphvsio]\ si ;. |M Cyclop Med. (Fin-sol Bortz) Phila, 1939, 3: 3N l_\ Mnbcrlcr. <;, Beitrag zur Pathologie der Epiphysiolysis capitis femoris Wien. klin. Wsehr, 1931. 47: 499 2. ---Oberschonkel- kopfkappenlosung Jugrudlichcr und Unfall. Miinch rued Wschr, 1937. 84: 661-0. Hark, I-'. \V. Treatment of separa- tion of the upper femoial epiphysis. Surg. Clin. N. America 1942, 22: 119 34. Ilarron-tein. R. .1. (Separation of the upper femoial epiph.\si- at l >irl h 1 Ned. tschr. geneesk, 1929, 7:i: l'.LO 3-1. pl. Henderson, M. S. Sli|iping epiphysis of head <>!' |. ft lemur. Surg. Clin. \ America, 1930. 10:38 1(1. Hiixter. Die I ,piph\ senlosimg als Ursache der Coxa vara. Zschr. orthop. <'hii, 1929, 52: 81-V Inoslroz i, A. Desprendi- miento epifisiario de la cabeza femoral. Bol. See. cir. Chile, 1933, 11: 351-5.—Irwin. S. T. Separation of the upper epi- physis of the femur. Clin ,1, Loud, 1929, 58: 229; 246. Also Irish J. M. Sc, 1929, 0. ser, 71-81, 8 pl. .lahss. S. A. Dis- placement of the. upper epiphysis of the femur (adolescent coxa vara) treated by closed reduction. J. Hone Surg, 1931, 13: 856-66. ------ Slipping of the upper femoral epiphysis; treatment in the pro-slipping stage. Ibid, 1933, 15:477-82. -' Jumpertz, F. Spatfolgen der Epipln senlosungen am oberen Femurende. Beitr. klin. Chir, I92S, 142: 460-70.- Ke\. J. A. Epiphyseal coxa vara or displacement of the capital epiphysis of the femur in adolescence. J. Bone Surg, 1920, 8: 53-117.— Klcinberg, S. Slipping of the femoral capital epiphysis. Proc Inst. M. Chicago, 193S, 12: 199. Also Cir. ortop. traumat. Habana, 1938, 6: 105-20, ch.-Lasserre. C. D6collement de l'6piphyse f6morale siiporieure; immobilisation plfitrce; resultat. Bordeaux chir, 1930, 7: 415. Also J. mid. Bordeaux, 1936, 113: 173.—Liitken, P. Epiphysiolysis capitis femoris (coxa vara epiphysarea) with special reference to bloodless reposition tieatment. Ada orthop. scand, 1939, 10: 1 19 -59.- MacAus- land. A. R. Sepaiation of the capital femoial epipln.sis. ,1. Hone Suig, 1935, 17: 353 09.—Massabuau & Guibal. Ustdo- tnyelitede la hanche, appiiraissant 8 mois nprSs un dccolleincnt de l'dpiphyse femorale siidSi i. ser, 25: 343-8.—Miilli, A. Zur Therapie der Epiphyseolysis capitis femoris. Schweiz. med. Wsehr, 1938, 68: 346-50.—Mulschler, H. H. Coxa vara epiphysaria und Unfalibegutacht un" M-dn Unfallh, 1939, 46: 15-28.—Nicolaysen, N. lEpiphvMeh ,!s of caput femoris and coxa vara] Med. rev, Ber em pi;ij )!): 97-110, 4 pl.—Nussbaum, A. Spatfolgen der Epiphysenlosung am oberen Femurende und Beziehungen zu Chondromen und zur Ostitis fibrosa. Arch, orthop. UnfaUchir, 1927, 25: 323-41. Also Beitr. klin. Chir, 1927, 140: 704 [Entgegnung von W. Muller] 70o.—Pacini, D. Sulla patogenesi dell'epilisiolisi essenziale del collo femorale. Chir. org. movim, 1939 40 25: A45"°T8'7x"Pe^e', ,C- N' dipped upper femoral epiphysis. Am. J. Dis. Child, 1941, 02: 081.—Pellegrini, O. Sulla pato- genesi del distaceo dell'epifisi superiore del femore Arch ortop, Milano, 1932, 48: 713 44.—Pelrignani. R. Decollement epiphysaire bilateral dc Texto-mite supeneure du femur. J. med. Bordeaux, 1937, 114: 208-71.--Pfeiffer. It. Die trauma- tische Losung der oberen Feinuropiphvso cine typische Ge- burtsverletzung. Beitr. klin. Chn, 1930 164- IS 30 — Pomeranz, M M. Epiphyseolysis or separation of the capital !m -6o'v4 the femur '" "^"'•■seence. Am. J. Roentg, 1938. 40: o80-J7. —----& Sloane, ML F. Slipping of the proximal '-'mi''al epiphysis; therapeulic results in 101 cases. Arch. Surg, l.Mo, 41): 007-2-1.—Pouzet, F. Traitement du decollement aigude La coxa vara des adolescents. LVou chir, 1930, 33: 409-72 — Keiidel N. /ur Pathogenese der EpiDliysonlosum' des Schen- Uelkopfes. I-ortseh. Roentgenstrahl, 1936, 54: 517; 1937, 55: 094.—Robb. J. J. Slipped epiphysis of the lead of the femur. But. M J, 1929, 1: 643.—Sacco, A, & Nicola. C. de Epifi- Tit? 'i"101"3,1 suPerior. Bol. Soe. cir. B. Aires, 1928, 12: i ii- ' ca.rl"!'' G' Sul trattamento della lussazione e|.ifisitiea dell anca Arch, ortop, Milano, 1927, 43: 17-54.—Scott, W. ^PJPhysioIysis of the uiipi-r femur. J. Bone Surg, 1936, 18: 743-00, 7 pl.—Sever. J. W. Slipping epiphysis of the head of the femur. Tr. N. England Surg. Soc, 1934, 17: 193-209, ch. HIP-JOINT 677 HIP-JOINT Also N. England J. M, 1934, 211: 1179-85.—Smith, M. K. Epiphyseal coxa vara. Am. J. Surg, 1928, n. ser, 5: 387-91.— Sutro, C. J. Slipping of the capital epiphysis of the femur in adolescence. Arch. Surg, 1935, 31: 345-60— Tavlor, V. J. M. Displacement of the upper femoral epiphysis; report on 23 cases. Brit. M. J, 1932, 2: 1003-7.—Vails, J. Epifisiolisis no trau- matica de la extremidad superior del Kmur. Rev. cir, B. Air, 1927, 6: 829-34.—Van Ilaelst. A. Decollement Epiphysaire de la tete femorale. Arch. fr. belg. chir, 1924, 27: 1098; 1926, 29: 928—Voss, O. Zur Behandlung der Coxa vara epiphysaria (adolescentium) Deut. Zschr. Chir, 1939, 252: 511-28 — Waldenstrom, H. On necrosis of the joint cartilage by epiphy- seolysis capitis femoris. Acta chir. scand, 1930, 67: 936-46. ----— Necrosis of the femoral epiphysis owing to insufficient nutrition from the ligamentum teres; a cUnical study mainly- based on experiences of the treatment of epiphyseolysis capitis femoris. Ibid, 1934, 75: 185-97, 5 pl.—Walter, H. -Spatfolgen der Epiphysenlosung am oberen Femurende und Beziehungen zu Chondromen und zur Ostitis fibrosa. Arch, orthop. UnfaU- chir, 1928, 26: 103-5.—Wardle, E. N. Etiology and treatment of slipped epiphysis of the head of the femur. Brit. J. Surg, 1933, 21: 313-28.—Wilson, P. D. Displacement of upper epiphysis of femur treated by open reduction. J. Am. M. Ass, 1924, 83: 1749-50. ------ Conclusions regarding the treat- ment of slipping of the upper femoral epiphysis. Surg. Clin. N. America, 1936, 16: 733-52. ------ The treatment of slipping of the upper femoral epiphysis with minimal displace- ment, J. Bone Surg, 1938, 20: 379-99. --- Coxa vara: Etiology. Bosselmaxx [H. W.] K. H. *Beitrag zur Frage der Konstitution bei der Coxa vara adolescentium. 21p. 22M|cm. Bresl., 1937. Heydenhoffer, J. *Ueber die Haufigkeit und Grade der Coxa vara bei der Arthrosis deformans des Hiiftgelenkes. 24p. 8? Miinch., 1934. Martens, H. *Coxa vara adolescentium und Trauma [Heidelberg] 20p. 20y2cm. Tub., 1938. Statjss, A. Die Aetiologie der Hiiftgelenk- deformitatcn; die Varusdeformitat ein organisa- torischer Effekt statisch-dynamischer Krafte. 140p. 24^cm. Stuttg., 1938. Yo Kwo. *Klinischer Beitrag zur Lehre von der Entstehung der Coxa vara. 20p. 8? Gott., 1928. Armstrong, J. R. A case of infantile coxa vara with notes on the aetiology. Lancet, Lond, 1935, 1: 1-498-500.—Bargel- lini, D. Sulla evoluzione della coxa vara congenita. Arch. ital. chir, 1930-31, 27: 578-84.—Beau, A. Les troubles endo- criniens dans la coxa vara essentielle des adolescents. Rev. fr. endoer, 1931, 9: 193-205.—Duncan, G. A. Congenital coxa vara occurring in identical twins. Am. J. Surg, 1937, 37: 112-5. ------ Congenital and developmental coxa vara. Surgery, 1938, 3: 741-65.—Fairbank, H. A. T. Coxa vara due to congenital defect of the neck of the femur. J. Anat, Lond, 1927-28, 62: 232-7.—Gardemin. Coxa vara adolescentium und innere Sekretion. Verh. Deut. orthop. Ges. (1934) 1935, 29: 114-7.—Gourdon, J. Coxa vara d'origine hypophysaire. Arch. fr. belg. chir, 1929-30, 32: 219-21, pl. ------ Coxa vara sym6trique par plicature de la partie sup£rieure des diaphyses f6morales. Bordeaux chir, 1931, 2: 381.—Hilgen- reiner, H. Zur Genese der Coxa vara. Med. Klin, Berl, 1931, 27: 159; 200.—Kreuz, L. Kritische Betrachtungen zur Morphologie der angeborenen Coxa vara (ein neuer Beitrag zur formalen Genese des Missbildungen) Arch, orthop. UnfaUchir, 1930, 28: 106-27.—Lindemann. Erbliches Vor- kommen der angeborenen Coxa vara. Zbl. Chir, 1941, 68: 23.—Mittelman, U. N. [Etiology of coxa vara] Ortop. travmat, 1931, 5: 55-65.—Nagura, S. Zur Aetiologie der Coxa vara, zugleich Beitrag zur Kenntnis der Transformation der Knochen. Arch. khn. Chir, 1940, 189: 533-49 (microfilm)— Nille, W. Zur Frage der Coxa vara adolescentium. Zschr. orthop. Chir, 1934, 61: 169-79.—Nyberg, E. [Coxa vara and internal secretion] Fin. lak. sail, hand, 1930, 72: 537-53.— Odasso, A. La coxa vara traumatica dell'eU giovanile con particolare riguardo al trattamento chirurgico. Minerva med. Tor, 1927, 7: 1258-69.—Parcelier. Un cas de coxa vara des adolescents, probablemeiit d'origine dysendocrinienne. J. mid. Bordeaux, 1928, 58: 317.—Saalmann. Zur traumatisehen Entstehung der Coxa vara adolescentium vom Standpunkt des Unfallbegutachters. Mschr. Unfallh, 1926, 33: 108-11 — Schapira, C. Distaceo epifisario dell'anca e coxa vara adoles- centium. Arch, ortop, Milano, 1933, 49: 419-53.— Schmidt, A. Zur Aetiologie der Coxa vara und der Perthesschen Krankheit. Zschr. orthop. Chir, 1927, 48: 229-39.—Schramm. Ein Beitrag zur sogenannten traumatisehen Coxa vara. Verh. Deut. orthop. Ges. (1937) 1938, 32: 143-9.—Seara, P. Artntis deformante de la cadera y coxa vara traum&tica. Rev. As. mid. argent, 1935, 49: 825-7.—Walter, H. Zur Genese dei Coxa vara. Med. Klin, Berl, 1931, 27: 1071-3.—Wishner, J. G. Bilateral coxa vara of unknown origin. Am, J, Surg, 1927, n. ser, 3: 74-6. Also repr.—Zimmermann, M. Unter- suchungen iiber Krankheitsbild und Aetiologie der sogenannten Coxa vara congenita oder Coxa vara infantum. Zschr. Orthop., 1938,68:389-415. ---- Coxa vara: Pathology. Feldmann, M. *Umbauzonen des Schenkel- halses bei Coxa vara und des Wirbelkorpers (vertebra plana Calve) [Munster] 20p. 8? Quakenbruck, 1937. Ishak-Ogly, A. *Studien zur Coxa vara (Betrachtung unter besonderer Berucksichtigung der Verlaufsrichtung der Epiphysenlinie) [Hei- delberg] 46p. 8? [Berlin-Charlottenb.] [1929] Madranges, M. Contribution a l'etude des coxa vara congenitales a fissure verticale [Lyon] 78p. 8? Bourg, 1934. Camitz, H. Etude comparee sur la coxa vara dite congenitale et l'osteochondrite eoxale .juvenile (coxa plana) Acta chir. scand, 1933-34, 73: 521-75, 2 pl, ch—Detchessarry, R. Coxa vara deformante en una luxaci6n cong6nita de caderas. Rev. ortop. traumat, B. Air, 1937-38, 7: 238-40.—Feutelai", P. Absence congenitale partielle du femur, coxa vara congeni- tale et luxation pathologique de la hanche. Rev. orthop. Par, 1929, 3. ser, 16: 45-9.—Freund, K. Beitrag zur Coxa vara adnata chondrodvstrophica. Arch, orthop. UnfaUchir, 1928, 26: 531-6.—Gutig, C, & Herzog, A. Der Beginn der sogenannten Coxa vara congenita; aseptische Schenkelhals- nekrose. Beitr. klin. Chir, 1932, 156: 551-4.—Jones, A. R. Retarded development of the femur, with coxa vara. Proe. R. Soc. M, Lond, 1934-35, 28: 645-7.—Karliol. G. Ueber den Verlauf der Epiphysenlinie bei der Coxa vara. Fortseh. Rontgenstrahl, 1929, 39: 326-30.—Laroyenne & Bouysset. Forme grave de coxa-vara bilaterale de 1'adolescence. Lvon med, 1929, 144: 3-7, 2 pl.—Levasheva, A. E. [Coxa vara (essential forms)] Ortop. travmat, 1937, 11: 25-37.—Mouchet, A, & Roederer, C. Coxa vara interne et coxa valga externe associees. Presse med, 1926. 34: 977-9.—Muller, W. Ge- neraUsierte Epiphyseolysis adolescentium und doppelseitige Falle von Coxa vara adolescentium. Arch, orthop. UnfaUchir, 1939-40, 40: 1-13.—Nove-.Iosserand & Pouzet, F. Considera- tions anatomo-cliuiques sur la coxa vara des adolescents. Lyon chir, 1933, 30: 189-207. ------ Forme speciale du coxa-vara congenitale avec platyspondylie. Ibid, 1934, 31: 469-72.—Papadopoulos, A. S. Sur un cas de coxa vara ante- flecta tardiva. Rev. orthop. Par, 1927, 14: 245-9.—Perrin, M. La coxa-vara, ses principales varietes. Medecine, Par, 1927- 28, 9: 1003-7.—Piergrossi, A. Sulla metafisite femorale di Bertolotti; coxa vara infantile. Arch, radiol. Nap, 1939, 15: 636-46.—Pouzet, F. Les formes frustes de la coxa-vara des adolescents. Presse med, 1932, 40: 1352. ------ L'frvolution anatomique des aplasies du col mmoral (coxa vara congenitales, a fissure verticale) Lyon chir, 1934, 31: 712-24.—Rocher, H. L, & Guerin, R. Coxa vara double des adolescents et patella bipartita. J. med. Bordeaux, 1929, 59: 354-6.— Sacerdote, G. Su di un caso di coesistenza alterna di lussazione dell'anca e coxa vara congenite. Minerva med. Tor, 1931, 22: 614-6.—Scholder. Ouverture de Tangle d'inclinaison du eol femoral dans un cas de coxa vara grave chez une fillette de 14 ans. Rev. orthop. Par, 1927, 14: 3. ser, 119-24, 3 pl.— Treves, A. Coxa vara de l'adoleseence suivie pendant toute son Evolution. Bull. Soc. chir. Paris, 1934, 26: 442-8.— Walter, H. Die Pathologie und Klinik der Coxa vara. Verh. Deut. orthop. Ges. (1929) 1930, 24. Kongr, 8-39. ---- Coxa vara: Treatment. Ferriere, J. *Transplantation du moyen feasier dans le traitement de la coxa vara grave; son indication dans quelques autres affections de la hanche. 56p. 2 pl. 8? Par., 1929. Hecker, F. *Die unblutige Aufrichtung der Coxa vara [Munster] 30p. 21^cm. Erlangen, 1936. Laratjche, R. Contribution a l'etude du traitement de la coxa vara congenitale. 63p. 8? Lyon, 1935. Albanese, A. L'osteotomia sottotrocanterica a zeta nella eoxa vara. Arch, ortop, Milano, 1935, 51: 791-813.—Berard, L, & Colson, E. Operations plastiques de la hanche dans une coxa vara inveteree, refection d'un toit cotyloidien. Lyon chir, 1936, 33: 207-10.—Camera, U. A propos du traitement chirurgical de la coxa vara de I'enfance. Bordeaux chir, 1932, 3: 449.—Delahaye. Deux cas de coxa vara, traites l'un par reinfraction l'autre par osteotomie sous-trochanterienne. Bull. Soc. nat, chir. Par, 1926, 52: 855-61.—Dreyfus, J. R. Sur quelques donnees nouvelles du traitement operatoire de la coxa-vara. Rev. chir. Par, 1937, 75: 378-89.------ Bol- zung oder Bohrung des Schen kelhalses bei Coxa vara Jugend- licher? Schweiz. med. Wschr, 1937, 67: 473—Furlong, R. J. The treatment of adolescent coxa vara. S. Thomas Hosp. Rep, Lond, 1936, 58: 173-7, 4 pl.—Gerber, W. J. [Easing 78 HIP-JOINT HIP-JOINT the weight on the hip-joint in coxa vara] Xed. tschr. geneesk, 1929. 73: 246-9. pl.- Haas. S. I.. Lengthening of the femur with simultaneous direction of covi vara. J. Bone Surg, 1933. 15: 219-24.- HarrenMoin. R- J. [Coxa vara congenita treated by Brandes method and l>\ osteotome] Ned. tschr. gcnec.sk. 1934, 78: 2913-23.—Henschen. Was kann thera- pcutiseh gegen eine essentielle Coxa vara adolescentis unter- nommen werden? Schweiz. med. Wschr, 1941, 71: 1354.— llodemann, H. Die operative Behandlung der Coxa vara. him. Wschr., 192V 7: 2250-3.- Junek. J. (Operative treat- ment of coxa vara infantilis] Cas. lek. cesk, 1930. 75: 1 10S 72. Also Zhl. Chir, 1937. 64: 277-9. Lamy, L. Transplantation du moven fessier dans la coxa-vara. Bull. Soc. chir. Paris, 1928, 20: 705-8.—Lange, M. Line neue Form der subt.ro- chanteren Osteotomie zur Behandlung der schweren Coxa vara. Zschr. orthop. Chir.. 1934, 61: 355-64. ------ Die Coxa vara, ihr klinische^ Mild und ihre heutige Behandlung. Miinch. med. Wschr, 1938. 85: 1637-41.—Lasserre. C. Subtro- chanteric oblique oMeatomv in coxa vara, with temporary external fixation of the fmgments. J. Bone -onir, 1931, 13: 296—8. ------ Coxa-vara de I'enfance traitee par osteotomie soustrochanterienne; resultat eloigne. Bordeaux chir, 1930. 7: 421. Also J. med. Bordeaux, 1936. 113: 185. ------ Coxa-vara congenitale; ostfiomie pertrochanterienne. Ibid, 1937, 114: 846-8.—Mauclaire. Reflexions sur la coxa-vara des adolescents et son traitement. Marseille mM., 1926. 63: 1121-33.—Mommsen. F. Zur Technik der operativen Be- handlung schwerster Formen der Coxa vara (Schiitz- und Zapfenosteotomie mit org.anz.-nder unblutigcr Behandkmg) Zsehr. orilmp. Chir, I'IL'9 30. 52: 53 4 -8. ■ Nes, ('. P. van ITreatment of coxa vaia in adolescents] Nod. tschr. geneesk, 1939, 83: 035 15. pl. ANo Hull. Soc. chir. Paris. 1939. 31: 173-85.—Noble. T. P.. .v Mauser. E. I>. Coxa vara. Arch. Surg, 1926, 12: 501 38. A l-o repr.—Noordenbos, W. [Treat- ment of coxa vara infantilis) Ned. tschr. geneesk, 1937, 81: 2303- 7.— Nove-Hosserand, G. Coxa vara traitee par l'osteo- tomie sous-trochanterienne. Lyon chir, 1938, 35: 470-2.— Pauwels. Zur Therapie der kindlichen Coxa vara. Verh. Deut. orthop. Ges, 30. Kongr. (1935) 1930, 372-88.—Perkins, G. Treatment of adolescent coxa vain. Brit. M. J, 1932, 1: 55. Pit/en. P. Die operative Behandlung der Coxa vara. ('hiring, 1930. 2: 97-103. Also Verh. I'eut. orthop. (les. 11929) 19311. 2 1. Kongr., 39 58. Pouzet. E. Sur le liaitement dc la coxa vara Congenitale en evolution. Lvon chir., 193S, 3f>: 107 11 Also Presse med, 193S, 46: 1095. Richter. E. Die Selh-tlieilung der Coxa varn. Veih. Deut. oithop. lies. (1929) 1931). 24. Kongr., 59-61.- Richter, \V. Ein Beitrag zur Bchaiidhnig der Coxa vara durch Abmeisselung des Tro- chanter major. Zbl. Chir, 1937, 64: 1347-52.—Rocher, H. L. Coxa vara double de 1'adolescence; osteotomie soustrochant.6- rienne gauche. J. med. Bordeaux, 1929. 59: 351-4.------ & Guerin, R. Coxa vara de I'enfance; traitement par greffe osseuse. Ibid, 1935, 112: 678-82.------Trois cas de coxa vara de I'enfance; traitement par greffe osseuse transcoivico- trochanterierine. Gaz. med. France, 1936, 43: 206.- Roederer, ('. Resultats de traitement des diverses coxa-vara des jeunes. J. med. Paris, 1938. 58: 53-6. ------ & Graffin, P. Notions sur le traitement de la coxa-vara. Techn. chir. Par, 1930, 28: 25-46.------La coxa-vara dite congenitale; son traitement rationnel. J. chir. Par, 1938, 51: 696-711.—Host. Zui Behandlung dei Coxa vara. Med. Welt, 1929, 4: 558.— Rovsing, C. M. [Case of traumatic coxa vara treated by arthroplasty] Hospitalstidende, 1926, 69: [Dansk Kir. Selsk. Forh.] 76-8.—Scholder. Coxa vara grave chez une fillette de 14 ans; ouverture de Tangle d'inclinaison du col femoral. Bull. Soc. nat. chir. Par, 1920. 52: 1025-9.—Sorrel. E. Coxa vara congenitale; resection cuneiforme de Tangle cervico-diaphysaire; remise en place apr£s retournemcnl du coin reseque. Mem Acad. chir.. Par., 1937, 63: 739-48.--Stracker, O. Behandlung der Coxa vara adolescentium mittels Lpiplivsensprengung Zsehr. Orthop, 1938-39, 69: 327-39- Tavernier, L, & Pouzet, F. Traitement de la coxa vara a fissure verticale pendant la croissance. Lyon chir, 1935, 32: 05-73.— Walter. Viiblulige Aufriclmmg des Schenkelkopfes bei Coxa vara adolescentium. Verh. Deut. orthop. Ges. (1934) 1935, 29: 125.—Walter, H. Sogenannte angeborene Coxa vara durch Umlagerung der Pseudarthrosenzone geheilt. Zbl. Chir, 1933, 60: 2359-61.— Wilhelm. Zur Behandlung der sogenannten kongenitalen Coxa vara. Verh. Deut. orthop. Ges. (1935) 1936, 30. Kongr 435-8. ---- Coxitis. Giordano, A. Sulla coxite con speciale riguardo alia sintomatologia e alia cura. 52p 8? Caserta, 1918. Benda, R. Beitrag zur Kasuistik und Pathogenese der coxitischen Pfannenprotrusion. Arch. Gvn, Berl, 1926 129- 186-203.—Butler, R. W. Transitory arthritis of the hip-joint in childhood; an investigation of arthritis of the hip in 97 children. Brit. M. J, 1933 1 : 951- 4 — Chatzkelson, B. Ueber ein neues Symptom dei Koxitis. insbesondere zur Friilidiagnosc derselben. Zbl. Chir, 1928, 55: 209-12. -Folaco Bclmonte, A. [Benign transient coxitis] Ned. tschr. geneesk, 1931. 75: pt 4, 5197-200.—Delherm. A propos de 2 observations d'arthrite coxo-femorale. Rev. rhumat. Par, 1934. 1: 308.—Del Torio, P. La coxite; lezione clinica riassuntiva. Gior. med prat ' 193S 20: 311-27.—Engel. D. Recurring arthritis of the hip associated with acetonaemia. Edinburgh M. J, 1937, 44; 780- 91.—Iversen. S. C. On the infantile coxitis and its acmielir- Actn orl hop. scand, 1937, 8: 231-92. Also Hospitalstidende] 1937.80:029 52, I 1 pl. lemma, G. Ksiti di osteoartrite acuta infantile c lussazione congenita dell'anca. Chir. org. movim, 1933 18:529 37. Kantin. A. V. (Roentgen diagnosis .1m\itis in children] Yost, rentg., 1910, 24: 207 12. pl.- hicnl>oc' . R. Entzundliche Hiiftgelenkserkraiikung mit starker k.....ti^ zerstdrung, Schenkelkopfnekioso und Osteochondritis dis,■, ,,,is, ferner Pfannenhodonpei foiatioii und pelviner Knplhixation! Rontgenpraxis, 1937, '.): S33. Lange, M. Die Krleichp., ung der Friihdiagnose der l\o\ilis •lurch hi her wenig beachtete Veranderungen im Rontgenbild. Zsehr. oithop. ('hir, 1927, 48: 90-7.— Levison [Intermittent coxitis] Hospitalstidende 1931, 74: (Neur. Selsk. Forh.] 24-6.- Maccnnti, A. II dolore inguinale nell'artrite dell'anca e sedi predilei to del dolore in artriti diverse. Arch, orlop, Milano, 1920. 42: 677 88. Monod. R. C, & Duret. M. Arthrites aigues de In hanche aver destruction de hi tele femorale en quelipies semaines. Mem Acad, chir., Par.. 1938, 64: 559.- Moulonguet, P. ^ur les lesions ladiologiipies de certaines arthrites aigues de la hanche J. radiol. electr, 1920, 10: 115-9.—Satta. F. La coxite bilaterale' Arch, ortop, Milano, 1932, 48: 895-914. Wyncn. W. Zu,- Frage der Friihdiagnose der akuten Koxitis. Zhl. Chir., 1927, 54:3230.— Zinner. S. Coxitis naeliahmendc KranUheitshilder' Verh. ungar. arztl. Ges, 1929, 1: 102-4. ---- Coxitis, chronic. Sep also subheading Osteoarthritis. Dtjvernay, L. L'arthrite chronique de la hanche. 145p. 8? Par., 1930. Le Cat, A. *La place de la section du nerf obturatcur dans le traitement de I'arthrite chronique de la hanche. 89p. 25cm. Lyon 1939. Arnaud, I, Traitement chirurgical des arthrites chroniques non tuberculeuses de la hanche par le forage du col femoral. P. verb. Congr. fr. chir, 1932, 41: 831-46.—Benoist. Sur 3 cas d'nrlhrite chronique de la hanche; conclusions pathogeni- cities el theiapeiitiques. Bull. Soc. chir. Paris, 1938, 30: 217- 25.—Calot. Sur le diagnostic des arthrites chroniques de la hanche par la forme de la tete femorale et. du col. Bull. Acad med. Par.. 1920, 3. ser, 95: 647-9. Also J. sc. med. Lille, 1926, 44: 131.- Charbonnel & Masse. Arthrodese extra-articulaire pour arthnte chronique douloureu.se de la hanche. Bordeaux chir, 1930. 1: 122 5. — Clavelin, O. L'extension continue en suspension dans le traitement des arthrites chroniques de la hanche. Rev. orthop. Par, 3. ser, 14: 351-0.—Cleret, F. Procede simple de traitement de la douleur dans tous les cas d'arthrite chronique non tuberculeuse de la h-nnhe. P. verb. Congr. fr. chir, 1932, 41: 771-3—Cuneo & Alivisatos. Resec- tion modelante, pour arthrite chronique. de la hanche gauche. Bull. Soc. nat. chir. Par, 1934. 60: 732 5. -Cuneo, B, & Rocher, H. I, Traitement chirurgical des nrtliriles chroniques non tuberculeuses de la hanche. P. verb. Congr. fr. chir, 1932 41: 545-744. Also Gaz. hop, 1932. 105: 1785-94. Also J. chir. Par, 1932, 40: 572-617. Also Presse med, 1932, 40: 1550.—Dausset, H. Rapport sur le traitement des arthrites chroniques non tuberculeuses de la hanche par les agents physiques. Rev. rhumat. Par, 1935, 2: 637-48.----— Dejust, & Ferrier. Les traitements physiotherapeutiques actuelles des arthrites chroniques de la hanche. Ibid, 193 I, 1: 299-307.—Dausset & Lucy. La radiotherapie est actuellement le seul traitement effica'-. des arthrites chroniques de la hanche. Bull. Soe. med. Paris, 1929, 318-21. Also Paris med, 1930, 75: 112-1.—Descarpentries. Traitement chirurgical des arthritis chroniques de la hanche. P. verb. Congr. fr. chir., 1932, 41: 815-20.—Dupuy de Frenelle. Traitement chirurgical des arthrites chroniques non tuberculeuses de la hanche. Rev. techn. chir. Par, 1932, 24: 175-92.- Duvernay & Parent. Considerations sur l'anatomie radiographique des arthrites chroniques de la hanche. Rey. oithop. Par, 1920, 3. ser, 13: 173-207.—Glauner, R. Zur Aetiologie der chronischen Hitft- gelenkentzundung. Fortsch. Roentgenstrahl, 1935, 51: 379- 87.— Graber-Duvernay, J. Donnees actuelles sur I'arthrite chronique de la hanche et son traitement. Gaz. hop, 1932, 105: 1224-8.------Un traitement nouveau de l'arthritc chronique de la hanche: le forage de l'gpiphvse femorale. Rev. med. est, 1933, 61: 602-6. Also J. m6d. Lyon, 1932, 13: 531-9. Also Acta med. scand, 1933, 80: 24-8. ------ Effets de la cure thermale apres l'operation de Duvernav; forage de l'epi- physe femorale dans les formes douloureuses de I'arthrite chronique de la hanche. C. rend. Congr. internat. hydi. clim. geol. med. (1-J33) 1934, 14. Congr, 469-71. ------ Le double-fond; sa signification dans I'arthrite chronique de la hanche. J. m6d. Lvon. 1934, 15: 95; 193. ------ Effets de la cure thermale apres l'operation de Duvernay (forage de Tepiphyse femorale dans les formes douloureuses de I'arthrite chronique de la hanche) Presse therm, clim, 1934, 75: 746. -—;— Resultats eloigns de l'operation de Duvernay; forage de Tepiphyse f6moraIe superieure dans les formes douloureuse. de I'arthrite chronique de la hanche. Rev. rhumat. Par, 1935, 2: 76:5-9.------Les indications op6ratoires dans I'arthrite chronique de la hanche. Rev. gin. clin. th6r, 1935, 49: 99 103. ------Indications, contre-indications, et resultats eloigns du forage de Tepiphyse femorale superieure dans les formes douloureuses d'arthrite chronique de la hanche; operation de HIP-JOINT 679 HIP-JOINT Duvernay. C.-rend. Congr. internat. rhumat. (1936) 1938, 5. Congr!, 217-21.------Indications et resultats eioignes de l'operation de Duvernay; forage de Tepiphyse femorale supe- rieure dans les formes douloureuses d'arthrite chronique de la hanche. Rev. rhumat. Par, 1937, 4: 103; 1938, 5: 100. .-----L'aspeet clinique des arthrites chroniques de la hanche d'origine congenitale. Ibid., 304 14.------Ce qu'il faut penser du forage dans I'arthrite chronique de la hanche (opera- tion de Duvernay) Monde med, 1939, 49: 113-5.—Guintini. L. Contributo alio studio delle artriti croniche non tubercolari dell'anca. Arch, ortop, Milano, 1932, 48: 687-712 — Lasserre, C. Arthrite chronique dc la hanche; arthrodese extra-articulaire par greffon tibial. Bordeaux chir, 1932. 3: 442. ----— A propos de I'etiologie des arthrites chroniques de la hanche. Ibid, 471. ------ Traitement de I'arthrite chronique de la hanche. J. med. Bordeaux, 1935, 112: 682.------A propos du traitement orthopedique de I'arthrite chronique de la hanche chez l'adulte. J. med. Paris, 1937, 57: 61. ------ Arthrodese extra-articulaire de la hanche dans I'arthrite chronique. J. med. Bordeaux, 1939, 116: 464.—Leriche, R. De la section du nerf obturateur dans les arthrites chroniques de la hanche. Mem. Acad, chir. Par, 1939, 65: 268.—Masini, P. Traitement des arthrites chroniques non tuberculeuses de la hanche. P. verb. Congr. fr. chir, 1932, 41: 796-9.—Masmonteil, F. Traitement chirurgical des arthrites chroniques non tubercu- leuses de la hanche. Ibid.. 812-4.—Massart, R. Traitement chirurgical des arthrites chroniques non tuberculeuses de la hanche. Ibid, 803-12.------Les arthrites chroniques amicrobiennes de la hanche. Rev. chir. Par, 1932, 70: 162- 99.—Merklen, R. Traitement thermal des arthrites chroniques non tuberculeuses de la hanche. Presse therm, clim, 1936, 77: 520-3.—Michel, G, & Guibal, J. Arthrite chronique de la hanche avec subluxation consecutive a une paralysie du sciati- que poplite externe. Rev. med. est, 1932, 60: 729.—Padovani, P. La section du nerf obturateur dans le traitement des arthrites chroniques de la hanche. Mem. Acad, chir. Par, 1939, 65: 58-60.—Pascalis, G. A propos du traitement chirur- gical des arthrites chroniques de la hanche. non tuberculeuses. P. verb. Congr. fr. chir.. 1932, 41: 821.—Poissonnier, M. Quelques reflexions sur ce qui s'est dit au congres d'orthopidie. J. sc. med. Lille, 1922, 40: pt 2, 294; 368.—RavauR, P. P., & Ceccalci, A. Les ondes hertziennes courtes dans le traitement de I'arthrite chronique de la hanche. Ann. Inst, actin. Par, 1932-33, 7: 204-7.—Richard, A. Remarques sur la technique de l'arthrodese pour arthrite chronique de la hanche. P. verb. Congr. fr. chir, 1932, 41: 823-5.—Roderer & Serrand. Sur les difficultes du diagnostic d'arthrite chronique de la hanche. Bull. Soc. radiol. med. France, 1934, 22: 154.—Roederer, G. La legende de la congenitalite k l'origine de toutes les arthrites chroniques de la hanche. J. med. Paris, 1929, 48: 77.—Rottenstein, G. Traitement des arthrites chroniques non tuberculeuses de la hanche. P. verb. Congr. fr. chir, 1932, 41: 828-30.—Saidman, J. Traitement des arthrites chroniques de la hanche par les ravons solaires concentres. Ann. Inst, actin. Par, 1935, 10: 40-5, 7 pl. Also Rev. rhumat. Par, 1935, 2: 738-43.—Scholder, C. Les orientations actuelles de la medecine dans le domaine de I'arthrite chronique de la hanche. Praxis, Bern, 1934, 23: 91-4.—Soupault. R. Du traitement chirurgical de I'arthrite chronique de la hanche. Rev. crit. path. Par, 1930, 2: 195-200.—Tavernier. Traitement chirurgical des arthrites chroniques non tuberculeuses de la hanche. P. verb. Congr. fr. chir, 1932, 41: 706-8.—Tixier. Arthrite chronique de la hanche gauche chez un homme de 50 ans, absolument impotent; arthrodese intra-articulaire; presentation de Topere 5 mois apres. Lyon chir, 1933, 30: 56-8.—Weissenbach, R. J, & Francon, F. Les orientations actuelles de la medecine dans le domaine de I'arthrite chronique de la hanche. Bull, med. Par, 1933, 47: 371-4. ---- Coxitis: Etiology. See also under names of general diseases as Syphilis; Tuberculosis. Fairbank, H. A. T, Daw, S. W. [et al.] Discussion on non- tuberculous coxitis in the young. Brit. M. J, 1926, 2: 828-34.— Gravinghoff, W. Siiuglingskoxitis und retroperitonealer Driisenabszess. Med. Welt, 1929, 3: 1434.—Lamarque & Betoulieres. Etapes radiologiques d'une arthrite aigue developpee au niveau d'une articulation coxo-femorale pre.sen- tant des lesions de coxarthrie post-traumatique. Bull. Soc. eiectroradiol. mid. France, 1938, 26: 80-2.—Piquet. J. Les arthrites de la hanche dans l'osteomyeiite de Tadolescence et de la seconde enfance. Rev. chir. Par, 1926. 64: 767.—SaxI, A. Ueber rheumatoide, rheumatische und traumatische Entzundung des Hiiftgelenkes. Zschr. orthop. Chir, 1933, 60: 195-202.— Slot, G. Traumatic arthritis of the hip; relief of pain by epi- dural injection. Proc. R. Soc. M, Lond, 1934-35,28:449 — Stropeni, L, & Colombo, C. Artrite dell'anca da malattia di Nicolas-Favre; arthritis paradenitica. Riforma med, 1939, 55: 3-5.—Vacchelli, S. Coxiti secondarie ad ascesso ossi- fluente da spondilite lombare. Chir. org. movim, 1934, 20: 257-62. ---- Coxitis, hypertrophic. Kuhns, J. G. Hypertrophic arthritis of the hip; a review of 79 patients. N. England J. M, 1934, 210: 1213-6. ----— The orthopedic treatment of hypertrophic arthritis of the hip. Surgery, 1942, 11: 839 (Abstr.)—Porta, R, Abnorme produ- zione ossea conseeutiva a coxite ed osteite ischio-pubica. Osp. maggiore, Milano, 1926, 3. ser, 14: 76, pl.—Sawyer, M. H, & Ghormley, R K. Pathologic study of hypertrophic arthritis of the hip. Surgery, 1941, 9: 381-93. ---- Coxitis, infectious. See also subheading Osteomyelitis. Grandrie, E. *Arthrites aigues suppurees de la hanche chez le nourrisson. 44p. 8? Par., 1928. Alvarez Samz de Aja, E. Coxitis estafilococica, como com- phcacion de adenitis inguinales. Chn. lab, Zaragoza, 1928, 12: 301.—Badgley, C. E, Yglesias, L. let al.] Study of the end results in 113 cases of septic hips. J. Bone Surg, 1936. 18: 1047-61.—Billet, H. Osteomyeiite du femur compliquee d'arthrite suppuree de la hanche. J. se. med. Lille, 1929, 47: 293-7.—Bowen, W. H. Suppuration in the hip joint. Guy's Hosp. Rep, Lond, 1938, 88: 482-9.—Broustet, P., & Caussain, J. L'osteo-arthrite de la hanche d'origine meiitococcique. J. med. Bordeaux, 1934, 111: 239-43.—Caldwell, G. A. Acute suppurative conditions of th* hip joint. J. Am. M. Ass, 1931, 98: 37-40. Also repr—Clavelin, C. & Naulleau, J. Diag nostic et traitement des arthrites infectieuses subaigues de la hanche ehez l'adulte. Rev. chir. Par, 1931, 69: 689-712.— Cooper, M. B. Acute pyogenic arthritis of the hip joint in infancy and in childhood. Am. J. Dis. Child, 1920. 31: 183-95.—Crooks, F. Four cases of acute suppurative arthritis of hip-joint. Proc. R. Soc. M, Lond, 1928-29, 22: Sect. Stud. Dis. Child, 107-9.—Deckner, K. Ner.artiger Rruckengips- verband zur Ruhigstcllung des Huftgelenks bei eitriger Koxitis. Zbl. Chir, 1933, 60: 1465—Etienne, Lapeyrie & Cabanac. Traitement par simple ponction d'une arthrite suppuree de la hanche a staphvloeoque blane. Arch. Soc. sc. med. biol. Montpellier, 1934, 15: 230-4.—Favre, M, Michel, P. J, & Danic, P. Arthrite aigue de la hanche de nature indeterminee, 1932, tcrminfe par une ankylose complete; lesions osseuses femorales satellites; discussion retrospective de la nature lymphogranulomateuse probable de cette arthrite, 1938; arguments cliniques et biologiques. Bull. Soc. fr. derm, syph, 1938, 45: 501-3.—Ferreira, J. A. Osteoartritis infecciosa de cadera de origen embolico. Sem. med, B. Air, 1940, 47: 472-8.—Fletcher, E. Two cases of infective arthritis of the hips. Proc. R. Soc. M, Lond, 1938-39, 32: Clin. Sect, 1380.—Forestier. J. L'atteinte de la hanche au cours des polyarthrites chroniques evolutives. Rev. rhumat. Par, 1936, 3: 53-6—Foster. J. B. Acute purulent arthritis of the hip. Texas J. M, 19.32, 28: 476-8.—Gash, I. W. Septic arthritis of the hip in a new-born infant following circumcision. J. Am. M. Ass, 1928, 91: 20.—Graber-Duvernay, J. Arthrite chronique de la hanche due au colibaeille. Lyon med, 1938, 162: 661-6, pl.—Hallock, H. Reconstructive and stabilizing surgerv; for residual suppurative arthritis of hit) joint; a study of 46 unselected cases. J. Am. M. Ass, 1939, 113: 2398-405.— Johansson, S. Ein Fall von septiseher Koxitis mit unge- wohnlichem Verlauf. Acta chir. scand, 1932, 71: 539-48, 3 pl.------A case of septic coxitis with strange develop- ment. Acta orthop. scand, 1933, 4: [Discussion] 84-8.— Kienbock, R. Ueber infektiose Polyarthritis bei Erwachsenen und Kindern mit Beteiligung der Huftgelenke und Pfannenbo- denvorlreibung. Schweiz. med. Wschr, 1934, 64: 688-92.— Lagos Garcia, C, & Masucci, A. L. Las artritis supuradas de la cadera en la primera infancia. Sem. med, B. Air, 1927, 34: 513-57.—Le Fort, R, & Piquet, J. Deux cas d'arthrite aigue de la hanche consecutive a une osteomyeiite de Tischion. Bull. Soc. nat. chir. Par, 1929. 55: 453-5— Lepoutre, C, & David, A. Arthrite aigue de la hanche chez un jeune homme de 16 ans, avec pus a staphylocoques, osteomyeiite; guerison par simple arthrotomie et mouvements suivant la methode de Willems. J. sc. med. Lille, 1930, 48: 397-402.—Leriche, R. Arthrite suppuree de la hanche a staphylocoques dor6s; traitement par des injections intraarticulaires de mercurochrome. Lyon chir, 1937, 34: 191-4.—Lombard, P. Les consequences eioignees, apres 45 ans. d'une arthrite purulente de la hanche survenue dans la premiere enfance. Rev. orthop. Par, 1929, 3. ser, 16: 426-9.—Maas, D. van der [Suppurative coxitis due to metastasis] Tschr. diergeneesk.. 1934, 61: 197.— Madier, J, & Ducroquet, R. Osteo-arthrite de la hanche a la suite d'une fievre paratyphoiide B. Bull. Soc. pediat. Paris, 1928, 26: 157-63.—Minne, J, & Loorius. R. Suites eioignees d'une arthrite suppuree de la hanche. Echo med. nord, 1930, 34: 613-5.—Nicholson, J. T. Septic arthritis of the hip; treatment by immobilization. Pennsylvania M. J, 1939-40, 43: 950-5.—O'Donoghue, A. F. Septic arthritis in the hip caused by Brucella melitensis; report of case. J. Bone Surg, 1933, 15: 506-8.—Perricone, F. La trazione col filo in un caso di artrite post-tinea dell'anca. Arch. ital. chir, 1935, 39: 9Q3—Piquet, J. Les arthrites de la hanche dans 1 osteomye- iite de Tadolescence et de la seconde enfance. Rev. chir. Par, 1926, 64: 767; 1927, 65: 38.—Pouzet. Arthrite de la hanche k staphvloeoque consecutive a une osteite du col femoral et compliquee de sub-luxation; curieuse adaptation articulaire. Lyon med, 1929, 143: 683-5.—Roederer, C. A propos des osteo-arthrites suppurees du nourrisson; resultats par Touver- ture immediate de la collection et Timmobilisation ngoureuse. Bull. Soc. chir. Paris, 1928, 20: 412-5.------L'avenir des arthrites suppurees de la hanche du nourrisson. Ibid, 1931, 23: 254-61 .—Saidman, Lcnoel & Pascal. Ost6omyehte compliquee HIP-JOINT 6S0 HIP-JOINT d'arthrite staphylococcique de la hanche. Ann. Inst, actin. Par, 1936 37. 11: 92-6, 5 pl.- Slowirk. F. A. Purulent in- fection- of the hip joint; an analvsis of 60 cases. N. F.ngland | J M 1935 212: f.72-6.- Vogl. A. Aiisgeheilte metastatisehe j Coxitis. Deut. Zschr. Chir.. 193S 39 251: 441-3.-Rocher. H. I. Coxalgie fistulisee; arthrite suppuree >\ streptocoqims du gi'iiou; intervention sur la hanche et amputation de cuisse: g-i. riMui. Bordeaux chir, 1932, 3: I S3-5- Woodd-Walkcr. G. B. Suppurative Mnptococcal arthritis of right hip. Wist London M. .1.. 1935, 40: 9. ---- Coxitis, rheumatoid. See also Rheumatism. Dfranceau, G. *Lcs ondes hertziennes cburtes en applications locales dans le traitement de certains rhumatismes chroniques et en par- ticulier dans le traitement de I'arthrite de la hanche. 182p. 25cm. Lyon, 1933. Lamy, L. Rapports de la chirurgie et du rhumatisme chronique et en particulier de la hanche. Rev. rhumat. Par, 1935, 2: 745-64. Massart. R.. & Vidal-Naquet. G. Les rhumatismes chioniques paitieb. In their Prat, orthop. Par, 193X IIS 22. Vidal-Naquet, G. Notes sur le traitement chirurgical du rhumatisme clnoniquc de la hanche. Hopital, 1935, 23: 451-3. ---- Coxitis: Treatment. Ilergmann, K. Ueber Keilherde im Huftkopf. Deut- Zschr. < hii . 1931, 233: 252 61.—Bourde, Y, & Artaud. P- Sur le tiaitement actuel des osteoarthrites aigues de la hanche. '. :■.,?.. med. France, 1937, 44: 487-9.—Chatzkelsehn, B. Zur liehanillung der Koxitis mit der Chatzkelsohn'schen Geh- -ehiene und gleichzeitig eine kleine Modifikation in der Ex- lens,,,,, ,lor Schiene. Zbl. Chn.. 1920. 53: 280-7. —Cibert 7: 179.—Loubat, E, & Laporte, F. Sin 2 cas d'arthrite aigue de la hanche; gu6rison apres simple urthrotomie. bordeaux chir, 1932. 3: 73-7.—Marconi. S. Le aitiodcsi nella coxite sotlo i 15 anni di-etft. Arch. ital. chir, 1938, 52: 831-46. Marshall. I). V. 'The treatment of coxitis. .1. Hone Surg.. 1912. 21: 169-81.—Mathieu. P. A propos d'une communication de M. Sorrel sur le traitement des ail hi i- tes s,VI,e> de la hanche. Mem. Acad, chir., Par, 1938, 64: 1248. Melchart, F. Coxitis dextrn mit neuer Gelenksbildung bew.-glich ausg. h.ilt. Foit-eh. Roentgenstrahl, 1934, 49: 312. Also Wien. med. Wscln. 1934. 84: 693.------Koxitis, durch Turnen bewcglich ausgeheilt. Fortsch. Roentgenstrahl, 1934, 50: 019—Pucini. D. II quadro tardivo dell'artrodesi dell'anca nella coxite; evoluzione dell'innesto, modificazioni h.cah. Arch. ital. chir, 1938, 49: 619-59-Roederer, C. Resultat du traitement precoce de I'arthrite coxo-femorale aigue du nourrisson. P. verb. Congr. fr. chir, 11.127, 36: 11)51 -6.—Rouillard. J. Diagnostic et traitement des arthrites seche- coxo-femmaies. Sem. hop. Paris, 1928. 4: 373-80.— Schwarz. H. G. Die hohe und tiefe Osteotomie bei postkoxiti- scin-n Zintandsbildein. Arch. klin. Chir, 1932, 170: 263-82.— Sedillot, J. Deux cas d'arlhiite seche de la hanche gueris par des movens medicaux. Bull. Soe. med. Pans. 1936, 258-63. Also J. med. Paris, 1936, 56: 569.—Sorrel, F. La resection modelante du rebord cotyloidien dans les arthrites seches de la hanche. Mem. Acad. chir.. Par, 1938, 64: 1150-8. ------ A propos des arthrites seches de la hanche. Ibid, 1308. ------& Delahaye. A. Six cas d'arthrite seche de la hanche opere.s. Bull. Soc. nat. chit.. Par, 1932, 58: 1138.—Tavernier. Forage du col pour arthrite seche de la hanche. Lyon ehir, 1936, 33: 193-5.------La section du nerf obturateur dans les arthrites slches douloureuses de la hanche. Ibid, 1939, 36: 228-31.— Trosc. A. Die eihaltenen Ib-ultate in 26 nach der Methode Trosc operiei t< ii Fallen von Koxitis. Wien med Wschr.. 1940. 90: 925 7 Walton. L. H. F. Notes on a case of bilateral arthritis of the hip-.ioints treated bv capsulectomy Ploc. R. Soc. M, Lond.. 1938-39. 32: Sect. Orthop, 827-30 — Wilson. P. Treatment of arthritis of the hip-joint with the vitallium cup. Lancet, Lond, 1942, 1: 117. ---- Deformity. Durroquet. R, & Merklen. R. Discussion du rapport du Pruft*sc ur Mathieu. Rev. rhumat. Par, 1935, 2: 737.— Fischer, H. Fehlbildungen des Huftgelenks. Arch, klin Chir, 1933-34, 178: 541-57.- Golding. 1 C. IIip deforniilici in adults. Proc. II. Soc. M, I.oikL 1957 -38. 31: 9 10 2, 2 pl. Hilgenreiner. II. Zui angeborenen Dv-plisio der Hufte Z-eln. Oithop, 1938 39. C>9: 30-51. Jansen. M. The large bram, the wide pelvic girdle and the outst Hiding number of hip anomalies in man icoxn vara, coxa fracta, coxa plana, coxa valga, slipping epiphysis, malum coxae) J. Bone Surg, 1929,11:461-531.- Morville, P. The incongruous hip. Actu orthop. scand, 1933, 4: 133-53. Mutel & Rousseiuix. Ap„. ph\se sciatique. Ann. anat. path. Tar, 1926, 3: 650. Sa'tta, F. ('oxa protrusa. Radiol, med, Milano. 1929, 16: 993-1004. -Saxl. A. Zur Statik des defekten II ul i •■elcnkcs. Zschr. orthop. Chir, 1927-28, 49: 308 -82.-- l'cajl. C. <;. Deformities at the hip-joint in children. Proc. R. Soc. M. Lond, 1937-38, 31: 935-9, 4 pl. ---- Deformity: Etiology. Stauss, A. Die Aetiologie der Hiiftgelcnkde- formitaten. 140p. 8? Stuttg., 1938. Wiberg, G. Studies on dysplastic acetahula and congenital subluxation of the hip joint; with special reference to the rom plication of osteo- arthritis. 135p. 23cm. Stockh., 1939. Ilarisnnikov, K. I. (Development of deformities of coxa valga et vaia post amputationom in conjunction with functional adaptability of osteo-musculai system} Vrach. gaz, 1926, 30: 002-5.--Bottmann. K. Benbachtungeii iiber 11 iiftgelcnks- veninderungeu bei 19 Faniiliemingeho, igen. Zschr. orthop. Chir, 1930, 53: 327-44.- Charry. R. Le mesadapt ation dc la hanche. Rev. g6n. clin. thei, I93(t, 44: 289-93.- Duvernay, I.. Arthrites de la hanche et malformations infantiles. J. med. Lyon, 1927, 8: 437-43. Also Lvon med, 1928, 142: 281-7. - Forbes, A. M. 'The tensor fasciae femoris as a cause of deform- ity. J. Bone Surg, 1928. 10: 579-84.-- Hackenbroch. Die kongenitnle Mindenvei I igkeit des Hiiftgelenkes. Verb. Deut. orthoi). Ges. (.1936,1 1937, 31: 117 30. - Die HedeutuiiR von W'achstumsstorungcn an der Femur-Kopfepiphyse fiir die spiitere funktionelle Leistungsfahigkeit des rliiftgolenkcs. Zsehr. Orthop, 1938, 68: 178-87- Hilgenreiner, H. Die angeborene Dysplasie der Hiifte, eine Lrlikrankheit. Zbl. Chir, 1939, 66: 1713-6.—Wilhelm, R. Neue Beitrage zur Aetiologie der Sehenkelhals- und Sehenkelkopfverbildungen. Arch, orthop. UnfaUchir, 1928, 26: 537-71. ---- Deformity: Diagnosis. Calot. Le role capital ma is meeonnu des malformations dans la pathologic de la hanche a tous les ages. J. se. med. Lille, 1925, 43: 82 5. -Giacobbe, C. Lauca a scatto. Gior. med. mil , 1934, 82: 150-00. Giongo, F. Un caso di anomalia pelvi- [emoiale congenita. Atti Congr. ital. radiol. med, 1925, 6: 213.—Milch. H. The pelvifomoral angle; determination of hip-flexion deformity. J. Bone Surg, 1942, 24: 148-53.— Scaglietti, O. Ieonografia dell'anca a scatto. Chir. org. movim, 1932-33, 17:460-6. ---- Deformity: Treatment. Abbott, LeR. C. The correction of deformity in quiescent disease of the hip. .1. Am. M. Ass, 1926, 87: 1095-102. - Chakravarti, D. C. Two ruses of deformity of the hip joint corrected by osteotomy. Calcutta M. J, 1925-27, 21: 601 I, 2 pl. -Coste, F, & Fauvet, .1. Le fo-age medical de la hanche. Presse med, 1935, 43: 2002- 4. De Guetano. L. Due casi di leformilu dell'articolazione coxo-femorale, per vaste cicatrici addomino-crurali da scottature; autoplastic:!; guaiigione. Arch. Soc. ital. chir. (192X) 1922, 28: 199 -20 1. — Fitchet. S. M. Flexion deformity of the hip and the lateral intramuscular septum. N. England J. M, 1933. 209: 71-7.- -Gay. De I'importance des cures thermales et de la reeducation sta tique et cinetique pour adapter les hunches deficicntes a Tcquilibre phj siologique de la marche. Presse therm, clim, 1937, 78: 177-9.—llanflig, S. S. A new method of utilizing traction in the treatment of flexion deformity of the hip in hip disease. I. Bone Surg, 1930, 12: 429-32.—Miller, A. Deforming lesions of the hip and their treatment. Tr. R. Med. Chir. Soc. Glasgow, 1937, 31: 112-9.—Plntou. E. (Treatment of various deforming affections of the hip-joint bv acetabular resection according to Sniith-Pctersen] Nord. med, 1940, 5: 91-5.— Quirin. Fehlgang der Iiiifte und seine Behandlung. Fortsch. The, 1928, 4: 756-61.—Whitman, R. The reconstruction operation for deformity secondary to disease at the hip joint. Ann. Surg, 1927, 86: 123-8. ---- Disease. See also Hip subheadings (Coxalgia; Disease, etc.) Diez, J. Artropatias cronicas no tuberculosas de cadera. 185p. 23cm. B. Air. [1941] Henitte, A. C. Contribution k l'etude des coxartht ies. Bull. Soe. med. mil. fr, 1938, 32: 353-5. Also Presse theim. clim, 1938, 79: 401.—Brailsford, J. F. Diseases of the hip-joint and its immediate neighbourhood. Hi it. M. J, 1932, 1: 92.— Chandler, F. A. Some problems in the pathology of the hip HIP-JOINT 681 HIP-JOINT joint in children. Proc. Inst. M. Chicago, 1934, 10: 114 — Colaco Belmonte, A. [Affections of the hip-joint| Ceneesk. gids, 1936, 14: 121-9.—Francon, F. Un cas de coxarthrie incipicns avec lesions radiographiques, douleur articulaire et boiterie sans limitation des mouvements passifs. Bull, med. Par, ¥129, 43: 567-9.—Gickler, H, & Beininc, H. Zur Mechanik des pathologisch veranderten Hiiftgelenkes. Arch. orthop. UnfaUchir, 1934-35, 35: 644; 1935-36 36: 91 — Glaessner. Studie iiber den Ausgang von Hiiftgelenkserkran- kungen. Verh. Deut. orthop. Ges. (1928) 1929, 23 Kongr, 290-5.—Gourdon, J. De Taction du psoas dans les affections articulaires de la hanche. Presse med, 1929, 37: 3 —Hacken- hroch. Coxa valga luxans, Perthessche Krankheit und Arth- ritis deformans. Verh. Deut. orthop. Ges. (1925) 1926, 20. Kongr, 76-92 [Discussion] 96-101.—Hatt, R. N. Diseases and injuries of the hip joint. N. England J. M, 1036, 215: 749- 53 —Hodnett, J. O'B. Observations on some common affec- tions of the hip-joint. S. Afr. M. Rec, 1926, 24: 130-2 — Hohmann, G. Das gesunde und kranke Hiiftgelenk. Deut. med. Wschr, 1939, 65: 1433-5.—Jansen, M. |Circumference of brain, width of pelvis and various hip-joint affections in man] Ned. mschr. geneesk, 1927, 14:99-200.—Krause, N. I. [Expla- nation of Trendelenburg's symptom: function of greater tro- chanter in pathological mechanism of pelvo-femoral joint] Vest, khir, 1927, 259-79.—Leri, A, & Merklen, R. Les coxarthries (arthrites seches, deformantes ou rhumatismales de la'hanche chez l'adulte^ J. med. fr, 1927, 16: 403-12.— Merklen, R. Definition de la coxarthrie. Rev. med. est, 1932, 60: 335.—Miller, O. L. Hip joint affections in children. South. M. J, 1928, 21: 287-93.—Nizkovskaia, M. M, & Gratsiansky, V. P. [Osteochondropathy of the coxo-femoral joint] Vest, khir, 1940, 60: 374-85— Perrin, M, Louyot, P, & Roger. J. A propos dun cas de coxarthrie. Rev. med. Nancy, 1938, 66: 779.—Phemister, D. B. Growth disturbances resulting from diseases at the hip joint. Proc. Interst. Post- grad. M. Ass. N. America, 1937, 173-6— Ramond, L. La coxarthrie. In Conf. clin. med. Par, 1935, 12. ser, 1-29.— Rivarola, R. A. Trofopatfa osteocondral de la cadera. Sem. med, B. Air, 1926, 33: pt 2, 400-5.—Romich. S. Insufficientia coxae. Zschr. orthop. Chir, 1932-33, 58: 199-204—Santos, J. V. Changes which the articular cartilage of the hip joint may undergo. Surg. Gyn. Obst, 1932, 54: 650-02.—Scherb. Ueber die Analyse der Funktionsverhaltnisse am Hiiftgelenk und iiber deren Einfluss auf die Entstehung pathologischer Zustiinde an demselben. Verh. Deut. orthop. Ges. (1925) 1926, 20. Kongr, 130-9 [Discussion] 172.—Schmidt. L. [Chronic disease of both hip-joints] Ugeskr. Iseger, 1928, 90: 510.— Schroeder, W. F. Hip joint diseases. J. Kansas M. Soe, 1931, 32: 73-7.—Thomassen. C. Twee waarnemingen bij begin- nende heupgewrichtsaandoening. Ned. tschr. geneesk, 1933, 77: 386, pl.—Vidal. J. La coxarthrie. Rev. rhumat. Par, 1S37, 4: 364-77.—Vulpius. Krankheiten des Hiiftgelenkes. Ther. Gegenwart, 1926, 67: 80; 121.—Zaaijer, J. H. [Afleetions of the hip-joint] Ned. tschr. geneesk, 1929, 73: 2840-5; 1930, 74: 130. ---- Disease: Diagnosis. Philoff, K. S. *Der diagnostische Wert der Shentonschen Linie bei Erkrankungen des Hiift- gelenkes [Wurzburg] 30p. 8? Wiirzb., 1928. Brailsford, J. F. The diagnosis of diseases of the hip-joint. Lancet, Lond, 1932 2: 721.—Durham, H. A. Early diagnosis of the diseases involving the hip joint. N. Orleans M. & S. J, 1934, 87: 230-5—Fairbank. H. A. T. The diagnosis of a limp, with special reference to the hip joint. Lancet, Lond, 1928, i: 19-23.—Francon, F. Aspect radiographique pseudo-kystique ou en nid d'abeille dans la coxarthrie. Bull. Soe. radiol. med. France, 1937, 25: 656. ------ & Merklen, R. La forme gonalgique de la coxarthrie. J. med. fr, 1930, 19: 382-4.— Hart, V. L. Attitude associated with lesions about the hip- joint. J. Med, Cincin., 1930-31, 11: 311-6. Also Arch. Surg, 1931, 22: 103-Sl.—Kipnbock, R. Zur Differentialdiagnose der chronischen Hiiftgelenkleidcn. Med. Klin, Berl, 1936, 32: 309-11.—Knorr. H. Leber die quantitative Bestimmung des Trendelenburgsehen Phiinomens am Hiiftgelenk (gleichzeitig ein Beitrag zur Mechanik des Trendelenburgsehen Phiinomens) Zschr. orthop. Chir, 1925-26, 47: 365-84.—Krida, A. The diagnosis of affections of the hip joint. N. York State J. M, 1927, 27: 57-60.—Lamarque, P. Le diagnostic radiologique des coxarthries. Rev. rhumat. Par, 1937, 4: 378-93.—Louyot. P. Sur divers types de coxarthries. Rev. med. Nancy, 1938, 66: 781.—Lowenstein, W, & Kopfiwa, G. Beitrag zur Entstehung und Bewertung des Trendelenburgsehen Phanomens. Med. Klin, Berl, 1931. 27: 1857.—Martin & Ducrcquet. Presenta- tion de radiographics. Rev. rhumat. Par, 1935, 2: 726-9.— Merklen, R. Diagnostic precoce de la coxarthrie. Bull, med. Par, 1933, 47: 374-9—Perl es, L. Diagnostic precoce de la coxarthrie. J. med. Paris, 1939, 59: 287-9.—Kchulhof, V. [Low back pain and sciatica as symptoms of diseases of the hip joint] Gyogyaszat, 1935, 75: 151-4.—Williamson, G. A. Aids in the diagnosis of hip-joint disorders. Minnesota M, 1932, 15: 312-20. ■---- Disease: Etiology. Hildebrand [S.] W. *Zur Mechanopathologie des Huftgelenks (auf Grund einer Lahmung des Nervus obturatorius) 39p. 8? Lpz., 1935. Feistmann-Lutterbeck, E. Die Kretinenhufte COsteo- arthrosis cretmosa) Helvet. med. acta, 1937, 4: 329-54 — Gourdon, J. Les coxarthries de l'adulte, d'origine eoinreiiitale P. verb. Congr. fr. chir, 1927, 36: 1057-60.- Kaiser, H. Weiterer Beitrag zur Kenntnis familiarer doppelseitiger Hiift- gelenkaffektionen. Med. Klin, Berl, 1930, 26: 550.—Kien- bock, R. Ueber die tropho-statische Arthrose des Huftgelenks Arch, orthop. UnfaUchir, 1930, 28: 425-34—Moline'-y. Un cas histonque de coxarthrie traumatique non tuberculeuse de la hanche; la maladie du Prince Imperial (1866-67) Gaz hop 1935 108: 1522.—Moser, E. Huftgelenksersehlaffung bei langdauernder Untersehenkelerkrankung. Zsehr. orthop. Chir. 1935, 63: 280-3.—Orgler, A. Ueber eine durch den Roller verursachte Hiiftgelenkserkrankung. Deut. med Wschr 1926, 52: 1178.—Perrin, M, & Louyot, P. La coxarthrie traumatique. Paris med, 1938, 109: 481-5.— Thrower, W. R. The etiology of certain lesions at the hip joint. Brit. M J 1930, 1: 999.—Vails, J, & Verbrugge, J. La coxa plana; 1 artrite deformante dell'anca e la loro origine ereditaria (spunti casistici) Chir. org. movim, 1925-26, 10: 364,-72' ---- Disease, neuropathic. Barthelemy, R. Osteo-arthropathies tabetiques des 2 hanches. Bull. Soc. fr. derm, syph, 1923, 30: 147-9.—Conley, A. H, 7: 1147.—Weitz, H. Zur Luxatio centralis femoris. Zbl Chir 1928, 55: 1912 -L—Winterstein, O. Zur Behandlung der Luxatio coxae centralis mit Zug am Trochanter major. Ibid 1933, 60: 1710-2.—Young, R. Three cases of central disloca'^ tion of L.e hip-joint. Proc. R. Soc. M, Lond, 1940-41, 34: 512. ---- Dislocation, chronic. Mignen, M. J. Contribution au traitement chirurgical des luxations invct6recs de la hanche (butee et bifurcation associees) 89p. 8? Par 1931. Moret, M. Contribution a l'etude du traite- ment chirurgical des luxations de la hanche inveterees par la constitution d'une butee osteoplastique. 38p. 8? Par., 1925. Wuttke [geb. Jonscher] L. *Pfannendach- plastik und Osteotomie in der Behandlung der veralteten Huftluxation [Breslau] 31p. 21cm. Beuthen, 1937. Albanese, A. Nuovi criteri direttivi delle osteotomie sotto- trocanteriohe nelle lussazioni inveterate dell'anca. Arch ortop Milano, 1937, 53: 347-84.--Ames(i, F. de. Luxation iliaca antigua (6 meses) de la cadera derecha; resultado obtenido 2 meses despues de la intervention cruenta. Bol. Soc. cir. Chile 1934, 12: 139-45.—Anglesio, B. Sulla riduzione cruenta di lussazione traumatica inveterata dell'anca. Arch. ital. chir, 1938, 50: 87-90.—Bellando-Randone, T. Lussazione invete- rata dell'anca, da coxite, trattata con la osteotomia sottotro- eanterica bassa, alia Schanz. Chir. org. movim, 1934, 20: 187-92.—Bunne, F. Zur Behandlung der veralteten Luxatio traumatica des Huftgelenks. Zbl. Chir, 1936, 63: 194-7.— Charry, It, & Charry, G. La luxation inveteree de la hanche de ladulte. Rev. gin. clin. ther, 1937, 51: 817-20—Clavelin. Au sujet des complications des luxations de la hanche; luxations aneiennes non reduites; sequelles de luxations reduites. Bull. med. Par, 1936, 50: 325-9.—Desplas, B, & Moret. Traite- ment chirurgical des luxations de la hanche inveterees par la constitution d'une butee osteoplastique. Monde med, 1926, 36: 693-8.—Dionisi. H. Luxation traumatica inveterada de la cadera. Bol. Soc. cir. B. Aires, 1936, 20: 68-77.—Hacken- broch. Die subtrochantere Osteotomie bei veralteter Hiift- verrenkung. Arch, orthop. UnfaUchir.. 1930, 28: 228-39.— Henderson. M. S. Old traumatic dislocation of the left hip. Suig. Chn. N. America, 1930, 10: 44-7.—Kafka, V. [Palliative operative treatment of old dislocations of the hip joint; bifur- cation of femur by Lorenz method] Cas. lek. cesk, 1930, 69: 868-73, 8 pl.—Kanarek, J. [Operative treatment of a trau- matic dislocation of the hip-joint of long standing] Chir. narz. ruehut 1936, 9: 377-91.—Leveuf, J. Luxation traumatique ancienne de la hanche; reduction sanglante apres resection de la tete. Bull. Soc. nat. chir. Par, 1935, 61:435-9.—Mandruzzato, t. L artrodesi a trincea in alcuni casi di sublussazione invete- rata dell'anca. Arch, ortop, Milano, 1939 55: 210 77 - Massart, R. Les luxations aneiennes de la lianche Bull Soc. chir. Pans, 1938, 30: 76-81.—Mathieu. P. Traitement des luxations traumatiques inveterees de la hanche. Bull. Soc nat. chir. Par, 1935, 61: 425-9.------& Padovani. B lriutement des luxations traumatiques inveterees de la hanche. Gaz. med. France, 1935, 42: 433 0.—Orlov, N. V. |Suigie:il setting in old dislocations of the hip-jointl Kuban, nauch. med. J, 1928, 7: 5-11. -Sailer. K. [Operative treatment of chronic dislocation of the hip joint] Orv. hetil, 1927. 71: 14O8-/0.—Schede. Die Behandlung der veralteten Subluxa- tion der Hufte. \erh. Deut. orthop. Ges. (1925) 1926, 20. Koiim, 3130-5.—Verrea-iIt.J. E. Luxation de la hanche datant de 6 mois; reduction par manoeuvres externes. Bull. m6d. Quebec, 1928, 29: 47-9, 2 pl. HIP-JOINT 683 HIP-JOINT ---- Dislocation: Complication. Heizmann, O. *Unmittelbare und spate Folgeerscheinungen nach traumatisehen Hiift- gclenksverrenkungen. 37p. 8? Tiib., 1936. Roth, H. *Ueber Spatfolgen traumatischer Huftgelenksluxationen. 27p. 22cm. Ziir., 1940. Saga, J. *Ueber aseptische Hiiftkopfnekrosen nach Luxationen [Mtinster/Westf] lop. 21cm. Baruth/Mark-Berl., 1936. Banks, S. W. Aseptic necrosis of the femoral head after traumatic dislocation of the hip; report of 10 cases. Proc. Inst. M. Chicago, 1940-41, 13: 149.------Aseptic necrosis of the femoral head following traumatic dislocation of the hip; a report of 9 cases. J. Bone Surg, 1941, 23: 753-81.—Birch-Hirschfeld, A. Die Schenkelkopfnekrose des Jugendlichen nach trau- matischer Huftluxation und ihre Bedeutung fiir die Begutach- tung. Mschr. Unfallh, 1939, 46: 241-5.—Blumensaut. C. Ueber sekundare. Schenkelkopfnekrosen nach traumatischer Hiiftgelenksverrenkung. Arch. klin. Chir, 1936, 185: 720- 52.—Burns, B. H. Arthritis of hip following traumatic disloca- tion. Proc. R. Soe. M, Lond, 1934, 27: 1204.—Dyes, O. Hiiftkopfnekrosen nach traumatischer Hiiftgelenksluxation. Arch. klin. Chir, 1932, 172: 339-59.—Gaussel, A. Paralysis du nerf sciatique apres luxation de la hanche par accident du travail. Ann. med. leg, 1924. 4: 396-8.—Gerber. W. J. [Sequels of luxatio coxae traumatica] Ned. tschr. geneesk, 1933, 77: 3848-54, pl.—Haase, W. Seltene, partielle Hiift- kopjnekrose nach Trauma. Zbl. Chir, 1935, 62: 1997-9.— Isenschmid, R, & Rieben, G. Sehadigungen des Nervus ischiadicus bei traumatischer Luxation des Hiiftgelenkes. Schweiz. med. Wsehr., 1941, 71: 137-41— Kaijser. R. Ueber sekundare Schenkelkopfnekrosen nach traumatischer Hiiftgelenksverrenkung. Arch. klin. Chir, 1936-37, 187: 661- 7.—Kleinberg, S. Aseptic necrosis of the femoral head follow- ing traumatic dislocation; report of 2 cases. Arch. Surg, 1939, 39: 637-46—Massart, R, & Vidal-Naquet. G. Les sequelles et les resultats eioignes des luxations traumatiques fie la hanche; l'ankylose; I'arthrite deformante. Bull. Soc. chir. Paris, 1936\ 28: 439-53.—M Oiler, W. Experimentelle Untersuchungen uber Nekrosen und Umbauprozesse am Schenkelkopf nach traumatisehen Epiphysenlosungen und Luxationen und ihre klinische Bedeutung. Beitr. klin. Chir, 1924. 132: 490-522.— Mutschler. H. H. Sekundare Oberschenkelkopfnekrose nach traumatischer Ausrenkung des Hiiftgelenkes bei einem 14 Jiihrigen. Miinch. med. Wschr, 1939, 86: 258-60.—Nogueras, V. M. Luxation dc la articulation de la cadera v lesiones con- eomitantes. An. Hosp. S. Jose, Madr, 1929-30, 1: 5.— Polgar. Spatfolgen einer Hiiftgelenksluxation. Rontgen- praxis, 1934, 6: 552.—Potts, F. N, & Obletz, B. E. Aseptic necrosis of head of femur following traumatic dislocation. J. Bone Surg, 1939, 21: 101-10.—Stewart, W. .1. Aseptic necrosis of the head of the femur following traumatic dislocation of the hip joint. Ibid, 1933, 15: 413-3*.—Vavrda, J. [Coxitis in a dislocated hip-jointl Bratisl. lek. listy, 1933, 13: 310-20 — Zadek, I. Complicated traumatic dislocation of the hip; report of 3 eases. J. Bone Surg, 1930, 12: 419-28. ---- Dislocation, congenital. D!az Bordeu, E. *La luxacion congenita de la cadera; el problema de la luxacion congenita de la cadera en Chile [Chile] 80p. 26^cm. Santiago, 1939. Gerbaulet, F. *In welchem Alter kommen die kongenitalen Hiiftluxationen in der Berliner Orthopadischen Universitatsklinik erstmalig zur Untersuchung? [Berlin] 29p. 8? Charlottenb., 1936. Le Da.many, P. La luxation congenitale de la hanche. 246p. 12? Par., 1923. Allison, A. Congenital dislocation of the hip in young adults. J. Bone Surg, 1925, 7: 330-9.—Ashley, D. D. Con- genital dislocation of the hip. Med. .1. & Rec, 1929, 130: 83-6.—Auden, G. A. Congenital dislocation of the hip. Lancet, Lond, 1929, 1: 687.—Bade, P. Hippokrates und die angeborene Hiiftverrenkung. Acta chir. scand, 1930, 67: 34-42.—Batman, G. W. Congenital dislocation of the hip. Indianapolis M. J, 1930, 33: 212-4.—Bellei, A. A proposito della lussazione congenita dell'anca. Difesa sociale, 1935, 14: 673-80.—Berntsen, A. [Luxatio coxae congenita] Ugeskr. laeger, 1934, 96: 423-6.—Biezins, A. [Congenital dislocations of the hip-jointl Latv. arstu Z, 1928, 189 99.—Brau-Tapie. Luxations congenitales de la hanche. J. med. Bordeaux, 1936, 113: 7)5.—Chandler, F. A. Congenital dislocation of the hip. Pub. Health Nurs, 1941, 33: 170-81.—Chappie, C. C. Con- genital dislocation of the hip in infancy. J. Pediat, S. Louis, 1935, 6: 306-15.—Charier. Luxation congenitale de la hanche. Bull, med. Par, 1923, 37: 1105-8.—Congenital dislocation of hip-joint. Brit, M. J, 1940, 2: 843. Also Lancet, Lond, 1941. 2: 287.—Fairbank, H. A. T. Congenital dislocation of the hip. Med. Press & Circ, Lond, 1936, 192: 7-10. ------& Piatt, H. [et al.] Congenital dislocation of the hip. Lancet, Lond, 1939, 1: 393.—Freelich. Luxation congenitale de la hanche. Rev. mid. est, 19.34 62: 253-71 7 pl.-Garvin, J. A. Congenital dislocation of the hip. Arch. Pediat, N. Y, 1932 49- 255-7 — Gocht. Ueber angeborene Hiiftverrenkung. Med Klin Berl 1937, 33: 216—Harrenstein, R. J. [Congenital dislocation of thehipj Ned. tschr. geneesk, 1934, 78: 2910-3.—Kidner F C Congenital dislocation of the hip. J. Michigan M. Soc,'19*39" 3.8: T^r^'T?1"''13, A- Congenital dislocation of the hip' Am J. Dis Child, 1935, 50: 1075.—Lange, F. Die angeborene tluftverrenkung. Miinch. med. Wschr, 1928, 75: 2001-5__ Lussazioni (Le) congenite dell'anca. Osp. maggiore, Milano 1924, 3. ser, 12: 154-0— McFarland, B. Interesting problems associated with congenital dislocation of the hip. Liverpool Mod. Chir J 1932. 40: 20-5, 11 pl.—Margarit. F. Un caso anomalo de luxacion congenita de la cadera. Ars medica Barcel, 1928, 4: 331-5.—Martin-du-Pan, C. Luxation con-' genitale de la hanche. Rev. med. Suisse rom, 1932, 52: 208- 16, 3 pl.—Martin, J. W. Congenital dislocations of the hip. Nebraska M.J, 1927, 12: 296-300—Marx, V. O. IDiagnosis and treatment of congenital dislocations of the hip joint in the new-bornj Ortop. travmat, 1934, 8: 3-13. —---- [Con- genital dislocations of the hip-joint in the new-born] Ibid 1939, 13: No. 6, 23-32.—Michael. P. R. [Case of congenital dislocation of the hip-joint] Ned. tschr. geneesk, 1937, 81: 4633-6.—Moore. J. R. Congenital dislocation of the hip. In Cyclop. Med. (Piersol Bortz) Phila, 1939, 4: 772-86 — Morrill, G. N. Congenital dislocation of the hip. Ohio M. J. 1925, 21: 730-3.—Mouchet, A, & Roederer, C. Luxation congenitale de la hanche. In Trait6 med. enfants (Nobecourt & Babonneix) Par, 1934, 4: 618-36.—Ortolani, M. II problema della lussazione congenita dell'anca quale si prospetta oggi ad un pcdiatra. Cult. med. mod. Pal, 1938, 17: 374.—Paterson Toledo, R, & Oleaga Alarcon, F. Luxacion congenita de la cadera. Rev. ortop. traumat, B. Air, 1933-34, 3: 80-112.— Putti, V. Congenital dislocation of the hip. Surg. Gyn. Obst, 1926, 42: 449-52.—Raszeja, F. [On congenital dislocation of the hip-joint] Med. prakt, Poznari, 1935, 9: 418-39.— Ridlon, J. Congenital dislocation of the hip. In Abt's Pedi- atrics, Phila, 1924, 5: 278- 97. Also Rhode Island M. J, 1933, 16: 135-8.—Ridlon, R. Congenital dislocation of the hip; report of an unusual case. J. Bone Surg, 1928, 10: 501-5.— Salvati, A. A. Luxaci6n congenita de la cadera. Dfa med, B. Air, 1935. 7: 1398-402.—Schede, F. Die angeborene Hiift- verrenkung. Jahrkurs. iirztl. Fortbild, 1934, 25: II. 12, 1-9.— Schmitt. H. Die gebietsmassige Verbreitung- und die grosse Zahl der angeborenen Hiiftgelenksverrenkung im Vogelsberg lOberhessen) Zschr. Orthop, 1938-39, 69: 435-8.—Scholder, M. C. Luxation congenitale de la hanche. Rev. med. Suisse rom, 1931, 51: 467-81, 11 pl.—Smith, E. H. Congenital dis- location of the hip. Med. J. & Rec, 1924, 119: 248-50. Also Compend M. & S, 1927, 5: 105.—Tamini, L. A. Luxacion congenita de la cadera. Dfa m6d, B. Air, 1930-31, 3: 811.— Van Horn, E. Congenital dislocation of the hip. Am. J. Nurs, 1941, 41: 461-4.—Vianna. B. L'inexistence au Bresil de la luxation congenitale de la hanche. Presse med, 1935, 43: 1468-70.—Vulpius. Die angeborene Hiiftverrenkung. Ther. Gegenwart, 1925, 66: 539; 584. ---- Dislocation, congenital, bilateral. Chandler, F. A. Congenital dislocation of hip; an anatomical study of a case of bilateral congenital dislocation of the hip and other associated congenital deformities in a male infant 11 days old. J. Bone Surg, 1929. 11: 546-56.—Conzett, D. C. Bilateral congenital dislocation of the hip. J. Iowa M. Soc, 1936, 26: 638-40.—Gourdon. Reduction de luxation congeni- tale de la hanche, bilaterale chez une fille de 11 ans; reconsti- tution de3 cavites cotyloides. Bordeaux chir, 1933, 4: 402.— Guerin, R. Luxation congenitale double de la hanche chez une enfant de 15 mois; reduction progressive dans un appareil articuie; pas d'appareil platre. Ibid, 1936, 7: 419. Also J. med. Bordeaux, 1936, 113: 179.—Isigkeit, E. Ein Sitzstuhl fiir Kinder mit doppelseitiger Hiiftgelenkverrenkung im Gipsverband. Arch, orthop. UnfaUchir, 1927, 25: 263.— Landivar, A. F. Doble luxacion congenita irreductible de la cadera; operation de Froelich-Lorenz; resultado alejado. Bol. Soc. cir. B. Aires, 1937, 21: 1173-7.—Lange, M. Die soge- nannte angeborene Hiiftverrenkung. Arch. Kinderh, 1940, Beih. 21, 2-9.—Markel, H. H. A case of bilateral congenital dislocation of the hip. Surg. Clin. N. America, 1926, 6: 533-7.—Mauclaire. Resultat radiographique eloigne d'une ost6otomie sous-trochanterienne bilaterale faite il y a 40 ans par Kirmisson pour luxation congenitale de la hanche. Rev. orthop. Par, 1933, 3. ser, 20: 646-8.—Meyerding, H. W. Bilateral congenital dislocation of the hips. Surg. Clin. N. America, 1930, 10: 52-8.—Rocher, H. L. Resultat eloigne d'une luxation congenitale double de la hanche chez une jeune fille de 18 ans. Bull. Soc. med. chir. Bordeaux, (1924) 1925, 113-5. Also Gaz. sc. med. Bordeaux, 1924, 45: 203.—Rotten- stein, G. A propos d'un cas de subluxations bilaterales des hanches. Arch. fr. belg. chir, 1927, 30: 111-3.—Van Neck, M. Luxation congenitale bilaterale chez un foetus de 534 mois. Ibid, 1924, 27: 61-7.—Verning, P. Recherches sur la luxation coxo-femorale congenitale bilaterale. Gyn. obst. Par, 1928, 17:292-303. ---- Dislocation, congenital, chronic. Ferron, E. A. *Le probleme de l'osteotomie dans les luxations congenitales posterieures HIP-JOINT (>S4 HIP-JOINT invt'Lerees de la hanche; essai de classification des indications operatoires. 77p. 24cm. Par.. 1939. Garnier. C. *Etude des indications et de la technique des butees osteoplastiques dans les subluxations et luxations congenitales inveterees de la hanche et en particulier dans leurs varietes posterieures. 110p. S° Par., 1927. Lance, P. M. *Les osteotomies sous-tro- chantcrienncs dans le traitement des luxations congenitales inveterees de la hanche. 13Sp. 8? Par., 1936. Truchet, P. *Reconstruction arthroplastique de la hanche dans les subluxations et les luxations congenitales inveterees; technique, resultats eloi- gned, indications. 135p. 251L;cm. Lyon, 1938. Abbott, I, ('. The treatment of old congenital dislocation of the hip; with special reference to the use of skeletal traction before redu.-tiou by operation. Arch. Surg, 1926, 12: 983- 1003.—Bade I*. Die Sprengung der Hiiftgelenkspfanne, tin Mittel zur Heilung von iilteren. angeborenen Hiiftverrenkun- gen. Muntil, med. Wschr, 192S. 75: 1711-3.—Bade. Zur Behandlung von iilteren angel iok -non Iliiftluxationen. Verb Deut. orthop. Ges. (1928) 1929, 23. Kongr, 2S2-6.—Baj, L. Contributo alia cura incruenta della lussazione invetcrata dell'anca. Chir. org. movim, 1930-31, 15: 266-81. 9 pl — Brnlin. J. A review of old congenital dislocations of the hip treated bv subtrochanteric osteotomy at the Gothenburg Orthopaedic Hospital. Acta orthop. scand, 1934, 5: 109-18 — Camera, U. Cont i iluito til trattamento della lussazione con- genita invetcrata ii i iducibile dell'anca. Arch, ortop, Milano, 1923, 39: 457 60.- (harry, V. Resultat eloigne d'une luxation traumatique de la hande- datant de 2 mois et reduite par voie sanglante chez un enfant. Bull. Soc. chir. Paris. 1937, 29: 160-•'{. Chevalier, G. Luxation ischiatique ancienne de la hanche; reduction sanglante. Marseille med, 1933, 70: 289-92.—Colonna, P. C. Congenital dislocation of the hip in older subjects; based on a studv of 66 open operations. J. Hone Surg, 1932. 14: 277-98.—Cotte, G, & Latreille. Osteo- tomie sous-trochantei ienne pour une luxation congenitale nntieniie de la hanche. Lyon chir.. 1926, 23: 116-9. —Dahs & Schwarz. Die tiefe subtrochantere Osteotomie nach Sehanz bei veralteter Luxatio coxae congenita; Nachuiitersucliungeii nebst kritischen und epikritischen Beiiicrkungen. Arch. klin. Chir.. 1932. 169: 494-517.—Del Valle, I). Luxacion congenita de cadera en el adulto. Dfa med, B. Air, 1941, 13: 1145-9 — Dcutschlander, ('. Das Ileihingsproblcm der veralteten angeborenen Hiiftverrenkungen. Zschr. orthop. Chir., 1922-23, 43: 217-24.-------Grundsatzliches zur Hadikaloperition der veralteten angeborenen Hiiftverrenkung. Acta chir. scand.. 1930, 67: 202-307. Uebei die operative Radikalbehandlung der veialteten angel.oiehen Hiiftverren- kungen. Zschr. orthop. Chir.. 1923. 44: iVcih. Deut. orthop. Ges, 17. Kongr., 1922) 147-63.--Dickson. F. I). I lie operative treatment of old congenital dislocation of the hip. J. Bone Surg, 1924, 6: 262-77.—Kliasberg. F. E. [Sdiantz' operation in old congenital und pathological dislocations of the hip] Ortop. travmat, 1938, 12: 55-64.--Filippi, G. Indicazioni, tecnica ed esiti della biforcazione alia Lorenz nella cura della lussazione congenita invetcrata dell'anca. Chir. org. movim, 1934, 20: 113-25.—Fraenkel. J. Schwierige Einrenkungen angeboie'ier Iliiftluxationen; Hufteintenkungen im Erwachsen- cnaltei; der M. iliopsoas als Repositionshindernis. Deut. /.-tin. Chir, 1925. 190: 359-90.— Gamier, C. Les indications th- LutGes os-teoplnsti<|ues dans les subluxations et luxations c.niL'i'-nitales inveterees de la handle. Prat. med. fr, 1928, 7: 4S1-9. Also Rev. med. fr, 1931. 12: 659-64.—Gazzotti, I, G. Sul trattamento della lussazione congenita invcterata dell anca. Arch, ortop, Milano, 1923, 39: 147-75. Also Lev. ■ u th..p. Par, 1924, 3. ser, 11: 377. Also Rass. internaz. clin Hi, 1923, 4: 589. Also Studium, Nap.. 1923, 13: 381. \Ko Gior. med. Alto Adige, 1929, 1: No. 6, 3; Xo. 6, 3-IK— Gill. A. B. Operation for old congenital dislocation of the hip Sura. Clin. N. Ameiieu. 1926, 6: 1-17-53. Also .1. Hone Sur" ' 1928. 10: 696-711.—Henry. M. O. The Dickson roofing operation in old congenital dislocations of the hip. J. Lancet, 1929, 49: 23-5.—Janovics, A. [Poor results in operative treat- ment of old dislocat ions of the hip joint] Gy6gydszat. 1930, 70: 503-5.—Joldersma, R. D. Congenital dislocation of the'hip- case report. U. S. Nav. M. Bull, 1936, 34: 243.—Kienle, B. Erfahrungen mit der DurelimeiH-selung des Femursclmftos bei der nicht einreiikbaren Iliift vei renkung auf angeborener oder n-teomyelitiseher Grundhige. Z-tin. orthop. Chir, 1927, 48: 481-99. — Kortzeborn, A. Beitrag zur von Bayer-Lorenz'schen Gabelung des oberen Femurende^ bei veralteter kongenitaler Huftluxation. Beitr. khn. Chir, 1924, 131 : 664-9.—Kreuz. L. Gedanken fiber Heilwert und Leistung; die Behandluiig der veralteten angeborenen Hiiftgelenkvei renkung. Miinch med W>chr, 1931. 78: 739; 803.—Lance. M. Luxation congenitale de la hanche inveteree et douloureuse; reduction et refection d'un toit osseux au cotyle; guerison. Bull. Soc. pediat. Paris, 1925, 23: I 17-9. ------- Etude des troubles observes dans les luxations congenitales inveterees de la hanche. Gaz. hop, 1925, 98: 881-3. ------- Traitement palliatif des luxations congenitales inveterees de la hanche. Presse med, 1925, 33: 1127. Also Rev. orthop. Par, 1925, 3. ser, 12: 557 632. — ---- Traitement chirurgical des subluxations et luxations congenitales inveterees de la hanche. Monde mid.. I'.ijti, 36: 573-85.------- Indications et resultats des operations nstli*. plastiques pratiquees dans les subluxations et luxations con- genitales inveterees de la hanche. Marseille m6d, 1927. til: 506-22. ------- Lo trailement chirurgical des subluxation.-* et luxations congenitales inveterees de la handle. Gaz. med. France, 1928. 170-3.— Lance, P. Indications th6r(i|icnt ii|nt>» et traitement chirurgical des luxations congenitales iim'-n'iiVs de la hanche. Medecine. Par, 1937. 18: SK9 901. Loonier. K. Operative Behandlung veralteter kongenitaler llufiluviiionen Krg. Chir. Orthop, 1923, 16:484-515. Lombard. I'. Luxation congenitale de la ham-he chez un enfant de 9 ans; reduction aprls traction sur la broehe de Kirschner; operation de N'ove- Josserant. Bull. Soc. nat. chir. Par, 1935, 61: 988 91. - Massart, R. Traitement chirurgical des luxations congenitales de la hanche, negligees et devenues douloureuses, par la hifurca- tion associee a la butee. Bull. Soc. chir. Paris, 1930, 22: 2S.3 -95. ------- Les luxations congenitales de la hanche non ttaitees dans I'enfance. Rev. gin. clin. ther, 1932, 46: 07-9. ------- & Vidal-Naquet. G. Traitement chirurgical des luxa- tions congenitales inveterees de la hanche. Cliuiquo, Par, 1934. 29: 23.—Mommsen. Erfahrungen iiber die Dosierung der tiefen < iberschenkolostootomie nach Sehanz bei der ver- alteten angeborenen 11 iif I luxat ion. Zsehr. orthop. Oliir 1924-25, 46: Beil. H, 188 92. Papin. E. Appareil ortho- pedique en celluloid pour luxation congenitale ancienne de la hanche. Bull. Soe. med. chir. Bordeaux (1921) 1922, 406.- Perrenot, F. Radiographic de vieille luxation e0ng6nitale de la hanche larvee. Loire med, 1923, 37: 549.--Pitzen. Beitrage zur' Pathologie und Therapie veralteter angeborener Iluft- venenkungeri. Zsehr. oithop. Chir, 192-1-25, 46: Beil, 202- 7. I'lagemann. II. Neue Wege zur Reposition veralteter kongenitaler Iliiftgel -nkverrenkungen. Deut. Zschr. Chir. 1925, 192: 128-35.—Saxl. Die Huftkontraktur bei nicht- reponierten (kongenitalen) Hiiftverrenkungen. Zschr. orthop. Chir, 1921-25, 46: Beil, 147-55— Schepelmann, 1'. Leber die Behandlung veralteter kongenitaler Hiiftluxationen. Arch. orthop. UnfaUchir, 1924-25. 23: 464-6.—Scholder, C. Con- tribution k l'etude de la stabilisation dc la hanche par refection osteoplastique du toit du eotvle chez les luxes congenitaiix invc'len'es. Acta chir. scand, 1930, 67: 751-9. SeifTert. K. Die Behandlung der veralteten angeborenen I luftgclenks- vei renkung. Beitr. klin. Chir, 1928-29, 145: 579-93.- Tavernier. L'osteotomie sous-trochantei ienne dans la luxation c .ng.'iiitale inveteree de la hanche. Lyon chir, 1938, 35: 474-6.—Treves, A, & Vidal-Naquet. G. Luxations congeni- tales inv6terees de la hanche; indications du traitement chi- rurgical. Marseille med, 1933, 70: 691 7. Willirh. Die subtrochantere Osteotomie bei veralteter kongenitaler unci pathologischer Huftluxation. Chirurg, 1930. 2: 193 202.- Wullstein. Indikationen operativer Behandlung veralteter Hiiftverrenkungen. Zschr. orthop. Chir, 1924-25, 46: Beil. II, 163-72.--Zaromba, J. Contributo alia cura della lussazione congenita dell'anca invetcrata. Arch. ital. chir, 1933, 33: 940, ---- Dislocation, congenital: Complication. Fleischhauer, H. *Uel>or die angeborene Hiiftverrenkung und ihr ZusammentrcrTen mit anderen angeborenen Missbildungen, in Sondcr- heit mit der Knieluxation, der Kniestreckkontrak- tur oder dem Klumpfuss [Munchen] 16p. 8? Diisseld., 1935. Mendelsohn, B. *Ein Fall von angeborenem partiellen Defekt beider Sehlusselbeine, kom- biniert mit kongenitaler Huftluxation. 37p. 8°. Berl., 1915. Ouvrard, L. Contribution a l'etude de la coxalgie greffee sur la luxation congenitale de la hanche. 68p. 8? Par., 1927. Piriou, R. Contribution a l'6tude du traite- ment des arthroses de la hanche dues aux luxa- tions et subluxations congenitales; osteotomies sous-trochanteriennes. 80p. 24cm. Par., 1939. Annovazzi, G. La lussazione congenita dell'anca associata a malformazioni congenite. Arch, ortop, Milano, 1925, 41: 53-88.—Bade, P. Zusammentreffen von angeborener Hiift- vei renkung und Kindei lahmung, eine Indikation fiir die blutige Imposition. Anh. oithop. UnfaUchir, 1930, 28: 142-5.— Butler, R. W. Congenital dislocation of the hip in a cast of multiple congenital defoi-untie. Brit. J. Surg, 1933. 20: 662-5.—Charlier. A. Aithrite evoluant dans une hanche atteinte. de subluxation congenitale. .1. med. Paris, 1927. 46: 172.—Csorsz, K. [Congenital dislocations of the hip-joint with Dupuytren's contracture] Budapesti orv. ujs, 1930, 28: 61-2.—Delitch, M. Coxalgie greff6e sur une luxation con- genitale de la hanche prealablement reduite; enchevillement de la hanche. J. med. Bordeaux, 1938, 115: pt2, 199-293. - Dorfman, L. L. [Fracture of the thigh in bilateral congenital dislocation of the hip-joint] Sovet. khir, 1934, 6: 64-0, 9 pL— Forni, G. Sopra un caso di malformazioni multiple associate a lussazione congenita bilaterale dell'anca. Arch, ortop. HIP-JOINT 685 HIP-JOINT Milano, 1933, 49: 1126-38.—Fripp, A. T. Congenital disloca- tion of left hip; Perthes' disease of right hip. Proc. R. Soc. M, Lond, 1939-40, 33: Sect. Orthop, 530.—Gourdon. A propos d'une butee osseuse chez un enfant atteint de luxation congeni- tale retidivee. Bordeaux chir, 1932, 3: 456-8.—Lichtmann, M. Zwergwuchs mit kongenitaler Huftgelenksluxation. Ausz. Inaugur. Diss. Med. Fak. Univ. Bern (1935-37) 1938, No. 201. __Natzler. Angeborene Hiiftverrenkung und deformierende Gelenkleiden der Hufte. Verh. Deut. orthop. Ges. (1927) 1928, 22. Kongr, 191-200.—Papadopoulos, A. S. Sur un cas de luxation congenitale de la hanche avec spina bifida et paralysie partielle des muscles adducteurs du pied correspondant (jam- biers anterieur et posterieur) Rev. orthop. Par, 1924, 3. ser, 11: 75-7.—Roederer. Double pied bot et luxation congenitale de'la hanche. Bull. Soc. pediat. Paris, 1922, 20: 421.—Treves, A. Les arthrites des luxations congenitales de la hanche gueries. Rapp. Congr. internat. rhumat. (1932) 1934, 3. congr, 400-3.— Watermann, F. Ueber die Kombination der angeborenen Hiiftverrenkung mit kongenitalem Fibuladefekt. Zschr. orthop. Chir, 1924 25, 46: 581-93.—Zukschwerdt, L. Doppel- seiti: 121 31.—Fogliani, U. Nuovo tipo di appareechio per la cm a della prelussazione congenita dell'anca. Chir. org. movim, 1936-37, 22: 332 6.—Gaugele, K. Gibt es eine Subluxatio coxae con- genita'' Reitrag zur Diagnose der Kopfstellung bei der ange- borenen Hiiftgelenksverrenkung. Zschr. orthop. Chir, 1923- 24, 44: 509-91.—Guilleminet. Insuffisance du toit osteo- plastique dans certains cas do subluxations congenitales inve- terees et eompliquees d'arthrite douloureuse. Lyon chir, 1937, 34: 468.—Lance. Le traitement chirurgical des subluxations congenitales douloureuses de la hanche chez l'adulte. P. verb. Congr. fr. chir, 1925, 34: 745-50.-----Note sur le dia- gnostic radiographique des subluxations congenitales de la hanche. Rev. orthop. Par, J926, 13: 3. ser, 665-71. ----- Le diagnostic des subluxations cong6nitales douloureuses de l'adulte. Gaz. hop, 1931, 102: 1840-4.------Resultats du traitement chirurgical des subluxations douloureuses de la hanche chez l'adulte. Ibid, 1932, 105: 1389. ----- Le traitement chirurgical des subluxations congenitales doulou- reuses de l'adulte. Ibid, 1357—Lange, M. Der Nacht- apparat mit Extension, ein Verfahren zur Bekampfung dro- hender Reluxationen bei reponiei ten Huftgelenksluxationen und zur Behandlung angeborener Siibluxationen der Iliifte. Zschr. orthop. Chir, 1925-26, 47: 505-74.—Leni, E. Note di tecnica in tema di cura della prelussazione congenita dcll'mica. Chir. org. movim, 1936-37, 22: 176-82. —Malard & Ballan. Sub- luxation congenitale, stabilisee, de la hanche; considerations sur la frequence etle d6pistage de cette affect ions dans l'a rmec. Bull. Soc. med. mil. fr, 1935, 29: 243-8. Marottoli, O. Malattia di Perthes e sublussazione congenita dell'anca. Chir. org. movim, 1934, 20: 161-9.—Mathieu, P. Coxarthrie k forme subluxante traitee par butee d'appui et resection arthroplastique. Mem, Acad, chir. Par, 1938, 64: 558.—Molen, van der [Bilateral, congenital subdisiocation of t he hip-joint] ('.oiioe«k. tschr. Ned. Indie, 1937, 77: 1908.—Nove-Josserand, G. Resultats du toit artificiel dans les subluxations congenitale^ de la hanche. Lyon chir, 1937, 34: 494.—0wrc, A. Painful congenital subluxation of the hip. Acta chir. scand, 1935, 76: 369-81, 5 pl.—Pasquale, E. La ricostruzione del tetto cotiloideo nella sub-lussazione congenita dell'mien. Chir. org. movim, 1935-30. 21 : 149-88.— Putti, V. Statistica degli stati di prelussazione congenita dell'anca curati col metodo dell'abduzione e considerazioni sulle lussazioni embrionarie. Ibid, 1932-33, 17: 209.--Simons, B. Die Veranderung des Hiiftgelenkes bei der angeborenen Sub- luxation. Arch. klin. Chir, 1933, 177: 467-70 [Discussion] 202-8.—Van Haclst, A. Manifestations tardives de.subluxation congenitale de la hanche. Aich. fr. belg. chir, 1928, 31: 220 2.—Waldenstrom, H. On subluxatio coxae congenita in adults, and its treatment. Acta chir. scand, 1932, 72: 548-53. ---- Dislocation, congenital: Manifestation. Baron, A. Ueber zwei direkte Svrnptome der angeborenen Huftverrenkung. Zbl. Chir, 1920, 53: 2457-9.—Bettmann, E. HIP-JOINT 687 HIP-JOINT Ein einfaches diagnostisches Zeichen bei angeborener Hiift- verrenkung. Chirurg, 1932, 4: 4,98.—Bocchi, L. Atteggia- mento del piede in talo-valgismo rivelatore di prelussazione congenita delle anche. Arch. ital. pediat, 1936, 4: 541-50.— Castagnari, G. Controllo e rilievi radiografici sul segno dello scatto, nella prelussazione congenita dell'anca. Lattante, 1937, 8: 438-41.—Erlacher, P. J. Die Ueberkreuzung, ein Hilfs- mittel zur Friiherkennung der angeborenen Hiiftverrenkung. Zbl. Chir, 1939, 66: 100-2.—Lamy, L. Luxation congenitale de la hanche et coxalgie Rev. med. fr, 1924, 5: 227 Luxations congenitales de la hanche douloureuses. Arch. med. chir. province, 1929, 19: 141-52.—Lichti. Die Ver- wertbarkeit der asymmetrischen Schenkelfalten fiir die Friih- diagnose der angeborenen Huftverrenkung. Mschr. Kinderh, 1938, 74: 243-7.—Massabuau, Guibal. A. [et al.] Deux observations de hanches congenitalement desaxees accompa- gnees de troubles fonctionnels. Arch. Soc. se. med. biol. Mont- pellier, 1928, 9: 52-5.—Ortolani, M. Un segno poco noto e sua importanza per la diagnosi precoce di prelussazione congenita dell'anca. Pediatria (Riv) 1937, 45: 129-36. ------ Lo scatto dell'anca segno certo di prelussazione congenita nei lattante. Acta paediat, Upps, 1938, 22: 446-50.—Puky. P. [Trendelenburg's symptom in diagnosis of congenital dislocation of the hip] Orv. hetil, 1935, 79: 900-2. Also Arch. klin. Chir, 1937, 190: 390-6. ---- Dislocation, congenital: Pathology. Bomig [O. M.] H. *Die Umformung des Schenkelkopfes bei der angeborenen Hiiftver- renkung [Leipzig] 28p. 8? Zeulenroda, 1937. Helmke, W. *Die Umbildung der knochernen Huftpfanne bei der angeborenen Huftverrenkung [Munchen] 39p. 8? Diisseld., 1936. Ptjtti, V. Anatomia della lussazione con- genita dell'anca. 234p. fol. Bologna, 1935. Allison, N. The adaptive changes in the hip in congenital dislocation and their importance in treatment. J. Bone Surg, 1928, 10: 687-95.—Beck, H. Stiukturveranderungen am Schaft unbehandelter angeboiener Hiiftluxationen. Verh. Deut. orthop. Ges. (1928) 1929, 23. Kongr, 322-6.—Brandes, M. Ueber die Einstellung des Femurkopfes bei der Luxatio coxae congenita. Zschr. orthop. Chir, 1923-24, 44: 497-520 — Braun, A. Die pathologisch-anatomischen Grundlagen der Beekensteilstellung. Flexions- und Adduktionsstellung des Oberschenkels und des Hinkens bei angeborener Hiiftgelenks- verrenkung. Ibid, 1927, 48: 510-7.—Caprioli. N. Contributo alio studio della luxatio coxae congenita. Pediatria, Nap, 1925, 33: 1182-5.—Chenier, G. A propos de la luxation con- genitale de la hanche. Rev. path, comp. Par, 1919, 19: 309.— Debrunner, H. Natiirlicher Umbau des Trochanter minor als Frsatz des Hiiftkopfes bei einem Fall angeborener Huftluxation. Arch, orthop. UnfaUchir, 1930-31, 29: 53.5-8.—Di Prampero, A. Morfolcgiaradiografica dell'anca cosi detta sana nella lussazione congenita unilaterale. Chir. org. movim, 1939-40, 25: 1-16.— Engel. Aus der Pathologie des Huftkopfes bei angeborener Hiiftluxation. Zschr. orthop. Chir, 1924, 45: (Verh. orthop. Ges, 18. Kongr, 1923) 310-3.—Fairbank, H. A. T. Congenital dislocation of the hip; with special reference to the anatomy. Brit. J. Surg, 1929-30, 17: 380-410.—Farkas. A. Die Art der Sekundarpfanne bei der angeborenen und sogenannten ange- borenen Huftverrenkung. Verh. Verein. Orthop. Wiens (1937) 1938, 87. ------ The mechanics of the formation of the secondary acetabulum in congenital dislocation of the hip. J. Bone Surg, 1938, 20: 885-7.—Froelich. Antetorsion exag6- rie de l'extremite superieure du femur dans la luxation con- genitale de la hanche. Rev. orthop. Par, 1934, 3. ser, 21: 657.—Gickler, H. Ein Beitrag zur Frage der Luxatio coxae congenita. Arch, orthop. UnfaUchir, 1933, 33: 248.—Huhne, T. Experimentelles zur Anatomie des Trendelenburgsehen Zeichens. Deut. Zschr. Chir, 1925, 193: 1-8.—McCarroll, H. R, & Crego, C. H, jr. Primary anterior congenital dis- location of the hip. J. Bone Surg, 1939, 21: 648-64.—Marconi, S. Considerazioni sopra alcuni casi di lussazione congenita dell'anca. Arch, ortop, Milano, 1933, 49: 1167-71.—Marks, V. O. [Further observations on congenital dislocations of the hip-joint in the new-born] Ortop. travmat, 1938, 12: 25-37, 2 pl.—Massabuau, G, & Marchand, L. Les hanches con- genitalement desaxees. Paris med, 1928, 69: 66-73.—Massart, R. La hanche dite saine dans la luxation congenitale uni- laterale. Bull. Soc. chir. Paris, 1933, 25: 460-84.—Mayr, O. Neuere Beobachtungen uber die Entstehung der Kopfde- formierung ' bei der angeborenen Huftverrenkung. Verh. Deut. orthop. Ges. (1934) 1935, 29: 133-7.—Meyer, H. Ueber die Ursachen der Gelenkneubildung bei sogenannter ange- borener Huftluxation. Zschr. orthop. Chir, 1924-25, 46: Beil. H, 192-5.—Miyake, H. Rontgenologisches Studium iiber die Beckenknochen bei angeborener Verrenkung des Hiiftgelenkes. Jap. J. M. Sc, 1934-36, 4: Surg. &c, 324 — Nagura, S. Die Entstehung der Pfannendysplasie bei ange- borener Huftverrenkung. Zbl. Chir, 1939, 66: 1174-7 — Pratje, A. Angeborene Huftgelenksvcrrenkung und Ablauf der Ossifikation. Verh. Anat. Ges, 1936, 43: 229-39—Striegler, F. Ueber das Verhalten des Femurkopfepiphysenkernes bei angeborenen Hiiftverrenkungen im 1. Lebensjahr (D15) (unter besonderer Berucksichtigung der Hypoplasie und des verspateten Auftretens der Ossifikationskerne) Zschr. Orthop, 1938-39, 69: 51-74.-Timmer. H. [Two hip-bones from 2 adult patients with congenital dislocation of the hip-jointl Ned. tschr. geneesk, 1923, 67: pt 2, 689-91—Vigano A Sopra un particolare aspetto radiografico del collo femorale ncgh esiti della lussazione congenita dell'anca ridotta \rch ortop, Milano, 1935, 51: 187-209.—Wiberg, G. Relation between congenital subluxation of the hip and arthritis de- formans, a roentgenological study. Acta orthop. seand 1939 10: 351-71— Zatsepin, T. S, & Vishnevetskaya, L. R. [Patho- logico-anatomical changes in the eoxofemoral joint in congenital dislocations of the hip-joint in 5-year old children] Ortop travmat, 1936, 10: 7-15, 13 pl. ---- Dislocation, congenital: Prevention. Bauer. F. Entstehung und Verhiitung der angeborenen Huftluxation. Wien. klin. Wschr, 1934. 47: 517-21. •----- Congenital dislocation of the hip; its prevention and treat- ment with abduction braces. Lancet, Lond, 1936, 1: 1057-9. ----— Die friiheste Erkennung, Behandlung und Verhiitung der angeborenen Huftverrenkung. Kinderarztl. Prax, 1937, 8: 425; 471.—Bickel, B. Can congenital hip-joint dislocation be forestalled? Internat. Clin, 1929, 39. ser, 2: 290.—Chizhin, I. M. [Etiology and prevention of the so-called congenital dislocation of the hip] Ortop. travmat, 1938, 12: No. 6. 92-100.—Froelich. Traitement preventif de la luxation congenitale de la hanche. Bull, med. Par, 1930, 44: 397. ------ Zur Prophylaxe der angeborenen Huftverrenkung. Zschr. orthop. Chir, 1932, 56: 587-91.------Traitement precoce ou preventif de la luxation congenitale de la hanche. Rev. med. est, 1935, 63: 565-71. Also"in Livre jub. (Hart- mann, H.) Par, 1932, 253-8.—Gourdon, J. La prophylaxie de 1'insufFisance et dc la luxation congenitale de la hanche. J. med. Bordeaux, 1932, 109: 351-5.—Krukenberg, H. Zur Aetiologie und Prophylaxe der angeborenen Hiiftverrenkung. Mschr. Geburtsh. Gyn, 1926, 72: 295-7.—Lorenz, A. Vor- beugung der angeborenen Hiiftverrenkung. Mitt. Volksge- sundhamt, Wien, 1929, 41. Also Wien. khn. Wschr, 1929, 42: 114. ---- Dislocation, congenital: Prognosis. Diriks, D. *Guerison spontanee de la luxa- tion congenitale de la hanche. 72p. 8? Par., 1925. Anglesio, B. Guarigione spontanea di lussazione congenita bilaterale dell'anca. Minerva med. Tor, 1927, 7: 861-3.— Annovazzi, G. Contributo alia casista della guarigione spon- tanea della lussazione congenita dell'anca. Arch, ortop, Milano, 1922, 38: 267-76, 2 pl.—Bauer. F. Spontanheilung und Friihbehandlung der angeborenen Huftverrenkung. Wien. klin. Wschr, 1934, 47: 784 [Erwiderung von O. Flicgel] 784.— Dega, W. [Spontaneous healing of congenital dislocation of the hip-jointl Chir. narz. ruchu, 1935, 8: 167-79, pl. Also Zschr. Orthop, 1935-36, 64: 145-53.—Delchef. L'anteversion cause de reluxation tardive de luxation congenitale reduite; 2 cas gueris par l'intervention de Schede combinee dans un cas avec la refection cotyloidienne. Rev. orthop. Par, 1928, 3. ser, 15: 703-5.—Drehmann, F. Zur Frage der Spontan- heilung der angeborenen Huftverrenkung. Zschr. Orthop, 1938-39, 69: 410-29.—Ducroquet, R. Guerison spontanee de la luxation congenitale de la hanche. Rev. chir. Par, 1924, 62: 496-506.—Faber, A. Zur Frage der Spontanheilung der angeborenen Hiiftverrenkung. Jahrkurs. arztl. Fortbild, 1939, 30: H. 12, 19-24.—Fliegel, O. Spontanheilung und Friihbehandlung der angeborenen Huftverrenkung. Wien. klin. Wschr, 1934, 47: 494-6.—Gardemin, H. Zur Prognose der angeborenen Hiiftgelenkverrenkung. Kinderarztl. Prax, 1936, 7: 17-21.—Jungmann, E. Spontanheilung der ange- borenen Hiiftgelenksluxation. Zschr. orthop. Chir, 1924, 46: 216-22.—Kopits. Spontanheilungen von angeborenen Huftge- lenksverrenkungen. Ibid, Beil. H, 158-63.—Krukenberg, H. Spontanheilung der angeborenen Huftluxation. Ibid, 1925, 47: 79-85.—Landres, Z. A. [Spontaneous cure of the so-called congenital dislocation of the hip in the new-born] Ortop. travmat, 1939, 13: No. 4, 3-10.—Marconi, S. Sulla cosidetta guarigione spontanea della lussazione congenita dell'anca. Chir. org. movim, 1932-33, 17: 25-31.—Nagura, S, & Shira- hama, V. Ueber 10 Falle von Spontanheilung der sogenannten angeborenen Huftverrenkung. Zschr. Orthop, 1937-38, 67: 387 96. -Reviglio, G. M. Contributo roentgenologico alia conoscenza della riduzione spontanea della lussazione congenita dell'anca. Arch, ortop, Milano, 1929, 45: 416-31.—Slomann, H. C. On the spontaneous recovery of congenital dislocation of the hip. J. Bone Surg, 1924, 6: 38-49—Venezian, E. Guarigione spontanea della lussazione congenita dell'anca. Arch, ortop, Milano, 1930, 46: 679-86. ---- Dislocation, congenital: Statistics. Schmitt, H. [K. L.] *Die gebietsmassige Verbreitung der angeborenen Hiiftgelenksver- renkung im Vogelsberg (Oberhessen) 19p. 2312em. Giessen, 1938. Barros Lima. Luxacfio congenita da coxo-femoral no Brasil. Rev. brasil. cir, 1939, 8: 145-78.—Calot, F. Plus d'un million de subluxations ou luxations congenitales de la hanche en France; le remede. Monde med, 1931, 41: 1-13.—Chatterton, HIP-JOINT OSS HIP-JOINT C. C, & Flagstad. A. E. Analysis of congenital hips observed in pnvnle practice. J. Bone Surg, 1925, 7: 355-69. Ely. L. \V. Congenital dislocation of the hip; a di'iica! stiah ot 2'J cases. .1. Am. M. Ass, 1925, 84: 1027-9.- Irosch, 1, I elm die angeborene Hiiftverrenkung. Korbl. Allg. iirztl. Verein. Thiiringen, 1927. 56: 216-9.—Jemma, G. Rilievi clinico- statistici sui casi di lussazione congenita dell'anca osservati in Napoli nei dccennio 1922-1931. Rinasc. med, 1933. 10: 134-6.—Kahm. O. Die geographische Verbreitung der ange- borenen Hiiftvenenkung in Km hessen. Zschr. Kriippclfurs, 1938, 31: 67-73. Kantin. A. V. [On congenital dislocations of the hip and its frequcm v in both sexes] Vest, rentg, 1940, 24: 359-63.—Konietzko. H. Das Vorkommen der angeborenen Huftgelcnksverrenknne in Ostpreussen. Zschr. Kruppelfiirs, 1939, 32: 37-42— Mandruzzato. F. Studio statistico sulla lussazione congenita dell'anca. Chir. org. movim, 1929, 14: 200-11, ch.—Poli, A. Lussazione congenita dell'anca: rilievi clinico-statistici sul matenale del Pio instituto rachitici di Milano dal 1903 al 1936. Arch, ortop, Milano, 1937, 53: 3-69.—Scaglietti. O. Studio clinico statistico sui casi di lussazione congenita dell'anca osservati all'Instituto ortopedico Rizzoli dal 1899 al 1931. Chir. org. movim, 1932-33, 17: 225. Sonnenschein, A. Die Verbreitung der angeborenen Iliiftgelenkverreiikiing in Oestei reich. Wien. klin. Wsehr.. 1937, 50: 17D0-9.—Soutter. R, & Lovett, R. W. Congenital dislocation of the hip; a studv of 277 dislocations. J. Am. M. Ass, 1924, 82: 171-7- Steindler. A, Kulowsl.i. J, & Freund. E. Congenital dislocation of the hip; statistical analysis. Ibid, 1935, 104: 302-7.—Valentin. B. Die regionare Ver- breitung der Luxatio coxae congenita; ein Beitrag zur geo- graphischen Pathologie. Arch. ital. chir, 1938, 54: 791-804. ---- Dislocation, congenital: Surgery. Trappe |\V. H.] B. *Die in den Jahren 1907- 1912 in der Koniglichen Chirurgischen Klinik in Berlin gesammelten Erfahrungen iiber die ange- borene Huftverrenkung. Up. 8? Berl, 1914. Burns. B. H, & Ellis, V. H. Congenital dislocation of the hip joint. In their Recent Advances Orthop, Lond, 1937, 114-24.—Chandler. F. A. Congenital dislocation of the hip. Surg. Clin. N. Ameiica. 1933, 13: 1141-59. Corin. J. A propos de luxation congenitale de la hanche; causes d'iiisucces; operations aanglanles. Liege med, 1929, 22: 01 70. Delchef, J. Reflexions sur le traitement de la luxation congenitale de la hanche. Arch. fr. belg. ehir, 1922, 25: 208-75.—Engelmann, G. Ueber angeborene Huftluxation. Zschr. orthop. Chir, 1924, 45: 438-49.— Fitte, M. Vias de aceeso a la cadera en las luxaeiones congenitas. Sem. med, B. Air, 1930, 37: 073-8.— Kru'Mch. N'operons pas les luxations congenitales de la hanche. Rev. med. Nancy, 1937. 65: 914-52. --Gaugelc, K. Zur Anatomie und Rontgenologie des kindlichen Femur; Beitrag zur Behandlung der angeborenen Hiiftgelenksverrenkung. Zschr. orthop. Chir, 1'.(23-24, 44: 439-52.—Heitzmann, O. Befunde bei operierter doppelseitiger Hiiftverrenkiiiig. Klin. Wschr, 1923, 2: 19S2 -4.—Krida, A. Congenital dislocation of the hip joint. Am. J. Surg, 1929, n. ser, 6: 185-93 — Lambotte, A. Sur le traitement operatoire de la luxation congenitale de la hanche. Arch. fr. belg. ehir, 1922, 25: 244-6 [Discussion] 287-9.—McFarland, B. Congenital dis- location of the hip. Brit. J. Surg, 1938-39, 26: 791-9.— Massart, R, & Vidal-Naquet, G. Les luxations congenitales de la hanche. In their Prat, orthop. Par, 1938, 414-66.— Porter, J. L, & Lonergan, R. C. Congenital dislocation of hip. Surg. Clin. N. America, 1939, 19: 3-20.—Putti, V. Early treatment of congenital dislocation of the hip. J. Bone Surg, 1933, 15: 16-21.—Satanowsky, S. Indicaciones del trata- miento cruento de la luxaci6n congenita de la cadera. Sem. med, B. Air, 1935, 42: 1185-8.—Sudbrack, J. Ueber die Behandlung der angeborenen Huftverrenkung. Chirurg, 1933, 5: 541-4.— Treves, A. A propos de la luxation congenitale de la hanche. Bull. Soc. chir. Paris, 1933, 25: 542-4. ---- Dislocation, congenital: Surgery: Acci- dents. Kojotjharoff, V. *Des accidents nerveux consecutifs a la reduction des luxations con- genitales de la hanche. 67p. 25cm. Nancy, 1934. Adams, Z. B. Two unusual conditions presenting an ob- stacle to the reduction found by open operation for congenital dislocation of the hip. J. Bone Surg, 1926. 8: 507.—Cole, W. H. The open treatment of congenital dislocation of the hip; the operative technique with some of its complications. Ibid, 1935 17: 18-24.- Corret, P. Les accidents nerveux de la reduction de la luxation congenitale de la hanche. Rev. orthop. Par, 1932, 3. ser, 19: 5-24.—Haberler, G. Infraazetabulare Pseudoreposition bei angeborener Hiift gelenksverrenkung Zsehr. orthop. Chir, 1933, 59: 421-41. ---- Dislocation, congenital: Surgery: Meth- ods. Bockhorx, G. *Die Behandlung der ange- borenen Huftgelenksvcrrenkung durch Bildung | eines kunstlichen Pfannendaehes [Ilalle-Witten- I berg] lCp. 21cm. Bleicherode a. Harz, 1937. Bounekamp, J. *l>fannendachpl:is(ik bei Sauglingsostoomyolitis und angeborener Hiift- verrenkung [Minister] 20p. 8? Diircn, 1932. Mouchotte, M. ♦Contribution a l'etude des indications et de la technique des but des osteo- plast iques dans le tiaitement de hi luxation con- genitale de la hanche. l."><)|>. 8? 1'ar., I93S. Severin, E. Contribution to the knowledge of congenital dislocation of the hip joint; late results of closed reduction and arthrographic studies of recent cases. 142p. 24cm. Stockh, 1941. Vergez-Honta, J. Contribution a 1'dtude du traitement des subluxations et des luxations congenitales de la hanche reductibles et ineoer- cibles par la mdthode des butdes osteoplast iqucs. 74p. 8? Par., 1029. Allison, N. The open operations for congenital dislocation of the hip. In Robert Jones Birthday Vol, Oxf, 1928, 97-125 — Antonucci, C. Ricostruzione plastica del legamento rotondo nelle lussazioni e sublussazioui congenite dell'anca. Policlinico, 1938, 45: sez. chir, 201-9. -Assen, J. van [Bifurcation in congenital dislocation of hip joint] Ned. tschr. geneesk, 1932, 76: pt 2, 2164-70. Baeyer. H. von. Die Bifurkation nach Baeyer-Lorenz; ein Protest. Zsehr. orthop. Chir, 1923-24, 44: 591-3. ------ Zur Geschichte der Gabelung des oberen Femurendes bei irreponiblen angeborenen Hiiftverrenkungen. Zbl. Chir, 1927, 54: 1565.- Balensweig, L. Congenital dis- location of the hip; replacement operation. .1. Bone Surg, 1926, 8: 534-8.-- Bargcllini, I). Considerazioni su settecento- cinquanta lussazioni congenite dell'anca curate con il metodo di I'aci Lorenz entro il priino anno di vita e riesaminate ad oltre 5 anni dalla riduzione. Arch, ortop, Milano, 1940, 56: 3-28.— Bauer, F. Nuova cura della lussazione congenita deH'anca. Chir. org. movim, 1934-35, 19: 539-44.- Blishchenko. P. I. [Surgical setting of congenital dislocation of the hip-joint] ,1. teor. prakt. med, 1927, 2: 341T6.-Boppe, M. La reduction sanglante des luxations congenitales de la handle. .1. med. chir. Par, 1934, 105: 88-96— Boyy, J. Butee osteoplastique pour luxation congenitale irr£ductible. Liege med, 1929, 22: 1475-84. Also Ann. Soc. m6d. chir. Liege, 1930, 63: 11-0.— Brandes. M. Ein Korrekturverfahren hochgradiger Ante- torsionen bei der Luxatio coxae congenita. Zschr. orthop. Chir, 1923-24, 44: 489-97.—Camera, U. Esiti di resezionc intertrocanterica di un'estremit& femorale deforme, praticata a scopo riduttivo di lussazione congenita irreducibile per questa deformita. Gior. Accad. med. Torino, 1925, 4. ser, 31: 63-5.— Charbonncl. N6arthrose avec neo-cotyle ischiatique au cours d'une luxation congenitale de la hanche chez un homme kgi. Bordeaux chir, 1936, 7: 430.—Colonna, P. G. An arthro- plasty operation for congenital dislocation of the hip; a 2 stage procedure. Surg. Gyn. Obst, 1936, 63: 777-81.-----An arthroplasty procedure for congenital dislocation in children. J. Bone Surg, 1938, 20: 604-8.—Compere, E. L. The shelf operation for congenital dislocation of the hip. Am. J. Surg, 1939,43:404-13. ------ & Phemister, D. B. The tibial peg shelf iii congenital dislocation of the hip. J. Bone Surg, 1935, 17: 60-72.—Darcourt, G. Les conceptions actuelles du traite- ment chirurgical de la luxation congenitale de la hanche. In Actual. m6d. chir. (Fac. med. Marseille) 1939, 4. ser, 79-92.— Delahaye, A. Butee osteoplastique pour luxation congenitale dc la hanche; resultat eloigne. Bull. Soc. nat. chir, 1929, 55: 772-5.—Descarpentries. M. Traitement de la luxation con- genitale de la hanche chez l'adolescent par le vissage femoro- coxal. P. verb. Congr. fr. chir, 1923. 32: 743-50. ----- Nouveau traitement de la luxation congenitale de la hanche chez l'adolescent. Arch. fr. belg. chir, 1924, 27: 193-9, 4 pl.— Dcutschlander, C. Zur Frage der radikalen Operation ange- borener Hiiftverrenkungen. Verh. Deut. orthop. Ges, 20. Kongr. (1925) 1920, 340-9 [Discussion] 364. ------ Erfah- rungen iiber die Radikaloperation der angeborenen Hiiftver- renkung bei Erwachsenen. Deut. Zschr. Chir, 1931, 232: 52-77.—Dickson. F. D. Davis method for closed reduction of congenital dislocation of the hip. J. Bone Surg, 1925, 7: 873- 82. ------ The shelf operation in the treatment of congenital dislocation of the hip. Surg. Gyn. Obst, 1932, 55: 81-6. ------ The shelf operation in the treatment of congenital dislocation of the hip. J. Bone Surg, 1935, 17:43-7.—Dujarier, C. Luxation cong6nitale non fixee de la hanche gauche; con- stitution par grelTe d'un toit osseux; guerison. Bull. Soc. chir. Paris, 1923, 49: 1152.—Dupuy de Frenelle. Traitement de la luxation congenitale de la handle par la fixation de la tete femorale contre l'os iliaque. Paris chir, 1925, 17: 103-17.— Eisner, J. Zur Technik der subtrochanteren Osteotomie bei irreponibler kongenitaler Huftluxation (Bemerkungen zu dem gleichnamigen Aufsatz von Dr Car) Sehulte) Munch, med. Wschr, 1924, 71: 1027.—Epstein, G. J, £cm. Santiago, 1939. Albanese, A. Lussazione gonococcica dell anca in un neonate. Rinasc. med, 1929, 6: 309-12, 3 pl.—Baisch, B. HIP-JOINT 694 HIP-JOINT Pseudoluxation der Iliifte durch Beekensarkom. Verh. Deut. orthop. Ges. (1925) 1926, 20. Kongr, 349-52 [Discus- sion] 304.— Biirhert. Exostosen mit besonderer Kotnplikatioii. Zschr. orthop. Chir, 1927, 48: 59S- Ohaklin. V. I). Patho- logical dislocations and sub-dislocations of the eoxofemoral joint. Ortop. travmat, 1936, 10: 16-29.—Collins. F. M, & Mahudcvan, R. An unusual case of pathological dislocation of the hip. Madras M. J, 1938, 18: 32-4.—Corret, P. Ln cas de handle k ressaut d'origine articulaire. Rev. med. est, 1933. 61: 007-10.—Dieulafe, L. & Dieulafe, R. Luxation patholngique consecutive a une coxalgie suppuree traitee par butee ostoopla-stique. Bordeaux chir, 1934, 5: 279. Also J. mi5d. Bordeaux, 1934. Ill: 45.—Duefio, F. P. Un caso de Iuxaci6n patolocherungen. Rontgenpraxis, 1938, 10: 516-20.—Hellner. H. \ erknocherungen des Ligamentum iliofemoral am Hiiftgelenk. Ibid.. 1937. 9: 277.—Jansen. M. Pincemente du ligimenr rond de la hanche, leur,- causes et leurs effets. Chir. org. movim, 1934, 20: 12-9.- Schwaiger. M. Das Ligamentum teres femoris und seine Gffiis.se. Zseln Orthop, 1936, 65: 297-317. ---- Loose and foreign body. Polacco, E. Contributo alio studio dei corpi mobili dell'anca Arch. ital. ehir, 1929, 24: 671-89. ------ Corpo libero articolare, esito lontano di frattura del collo femorale Ibid 1929-30, 25: 94-103. Movements. Argiielles, R. Einfachc Untersuchungsmethode der Hoft- gelenksbeweglielikeit. Zschr. Orthop, 1935-36, 64: 98.— Boscoe, A. R. The range of active abduction and lateral rota- tion at the hip joint of men. .1. Bone Surg , 1932, 14: 325 31,__ Moore, J. B, & Vaughan, J. O. The range of active motion at the hip joint of men. Ibid, 1928, 10: 248-57. Also repr. ---- Orthopedics. Arkin, A. M. Movable traction carrier; an apparatus for combining traction with motion at the hip. J. Bone Surg 1939, 21: 1032-4.— Rendu, A. Presentation d'appareila orthopediques. Rev. orthop. Par, 1926, 3. ser, 13: 672-81 — Silfverskiold, N. Beekensiiitze, besonders fiir amlul.inte Praxis geeignet. Zbl. Chir, 1929, 56: Mojx. Winters, R. A. Nonoperative orthopedic technics; hip and sciatic nerve Clin. M. & S, 1940, 47: 52. Ziminski, T. Hip truss. U s' Patent Off, 1934, No. 1983829. ---- Ossification. Grosse, H. Ueber die Untcrsehiede der Ossifikations- storung des Pfannendachs und der proximalen Fenmrepiphyse bei mannlicher und wciblicher Huftverrenkung. Zschr Orthop, 1938-39, 69: 75-80.—Klein, N. Ueber Ossifikations- stcirungen beider Hiiftgelenke auf endokriner Grundlage. Rontgenpraxis, 1931, 3: 550-3. ---- Osteoarthritis [Malum coxae senile] See also subheading Coxitis, chronic. Padovani, P. *L'arthrite chronique ddfor- mante de la hanche. 192p. 8? Par., 1932. Alhaique, A. Sull'artrite deformante dell'anca. Rinasc. med, 1930, 7: 571.—Bazan, J, & Viola, B. A. Osteo-arthritia coxo-femoral doble con subluxation izquierda, consecutiva a una infection puerperal. Bol. Soc. obst. gin. B. Aires, 1929, 8: 116-25.—Crowe, H. W. Osteo-arthritis of the hip joint. Acta rheumat, Rotterdam, 1933, 5: No. 16, 12-5.—Durman, D. C. Morbus coxae senilis. Am. J. Surg, 1927, n. ser, 3: 263- 5.—Fischer. E. [Arthritis deformans coxae?] Orv. hetil, 1936, 80: 205; mell, 00.—Fletcher, E. Osteoarthritis of hips. Proc. IL Soc. M, Lond, 1938-39, 32: Clin. Sect, 1386.—Gibson, A. Osteoarthritis of the hip-joint. Manitoba M. Ass. Rev, 1940, 20: 113-5.—Gordon, R. G. The senile hip. Practitioner, Lond, 1926, 117: 36-42.—Graber-Duvernay, J. Osteite k coli- bacille simulant une arthrite chronique de la hanche. Lyon med, 1930, 157: 615-9, pl. ------ L'aspect clinique des arthrites chroniques de la hanche d'origine congenitale. Acta med. scand, 1938, 94: 495-505. ------ Diagnostic precoce de I'arthrite chronique de la hanche. Monde med, 1938, 48: 643-50. ------ Senilit6 et arthrite chronique de la hanche. Presse med, 1938, 46: 838-40.—Hackenbroch, M. Das Malum coxae senile. Chirurg, 1935, 7: 857-65. ----- Die Arthrosis deformans des Huftgelenks. Med. Welt, 1939, 13: 977-80, pl.—Hennes, H. Die Arthrosis deformans der Hiiften (.Malum coxae senile) ihre Erkennung und Beurteilung. Miintii. med. Wschr, 1937, 84: 1943-5.—Jensen, E. [Osteo- arthritis deformans coxae] Ugeskr. laeger, 1935, 97: 794-8.— Karp, M. [Osteoarthritis deformans of the hip-joint of haemo- philie origin] Bratisl. lek. listy, 1935, 15: 745-8.—Leimbacher, E. S. Osteo-arthritis of the hip. Proc. Inst. M. Chicago, 1940-41, 13: 415.—Mackenzie, W. A group of cases of de- structive arthritis of the hip joint in children. Newcastle M. J, 1926-27, 7: 191-200, 2 pl.—McMurray, T. P. Osteo- arthritis of the hip-joint, Brit. J. Surg, 1934-35, 22: 716-27. Also J. Bone Surg, 1939, 21: 1-11.—Malkin, S. A. S. Osteo- arthritis of the hip. Med. Press & Circ, Lond, 1940, 23: 379-81.—Manfredi, M. DeU'artrosi deformante deU'anca. Boll. Poliamb. Giuseppe Ronzoni, 1937, 11: 93-105.—Massart, R, & Vidal-Naquet, 6. Les arthrites chroniques deformantes de la hanche; la hanche rhumatismale. In their Prat, orthop. Par, 1938, 534-52.—Mathieu, P. Arthrite deformante de la hanche. In Traite chir. orthop. (Ombredanne) Par, 1937, 4: 3488-518.—Ory. De quelques cas debutants d'oisteourthrite deformante de la hanche. Liege med, 1934, 27: 738-44. - Padovani, P. L'arthrite chronique deformante de la huneln chez l'adulte (diagnostic et indications tlitiapnutiqiies) Bull. med. Par, 1932, 46: 279-82.—Page, C. M. Osteo-arthritn of the hip-joint. Lancet, Lond, 1935, 1: 1313-20.—Plate, K. Ueber einen Fall von Arthritis deformans des Huftgelenks entstanden durch Presslufteinwirkung, nebst Betrachtungen iiber das Zustandekorntnen soldier Erkrankungen. Arch. orthop. UnfaUchir, 1928, 26: 201-17.—Plewes, L. W. Osteo- arthritis of the hip. Brit. .1 Surg, 1939-40, 27: 682-95.— Roederer, C. Les faux morbus coxae senilis et les vraia Bull. Soc. med. Paris, 1928, 470-9.------Le vrai et le faux morbus coxae senilis. P. verb. Congr. fr. chir., 1928, 37: 570-5.------Les faux morbus coxae senilis et les vrais. Clinique, Par, 1930, 25: 49-51.—Schoemaker. Arthrite deformante de la hanche. P. verb. Congr. fr. chir, 1932, 41: 830.— Stotzer, E. Differentialdiagnose zwischen Arthritis deformans coxae (Pscudocoxitis) und der Ischias (beziehungs- weise Pseudoischias) Schweiz. med. Wschr, 1936, 66: 286.— Thirion, G. Osteo-arthrite de la hanche, d'identification difficile. J. sc. med. LiUe, 1928, 46: pt 2, 97-9, pl. HIP-JOINT 697 HIP-JOINT ---- Osteoarthritis: Pathology. Kessel, R. *Osteo-arthrite coxo-femorale d'origine typhique et paratyphique. 68p. 8? Par., 1929. Baj, L. Contributo alio studio dell'osteoartrite urica dell'anca. Gior. batt. immun, 1931, 6: 331-6.—Bergmann, E. Die Modellierung der Hufte bei Arthritis deformans und ihre Spatresultate. Arch. klin. Chir, 1928, 150: 259-65.—Bonn, R. Ossale Arthritis deformans nach traumatischer Hiiftgelenks- luxation. Ibid, 1924, 129: 686-99.—Carli, C. Rapporto fra artrite deformante e sub-hissazione congenita dell'anca. Chir. org. movim, 1934, 20: 227-32.—Ciaccia, S. Osteoartrite deformante infantile dell'anca. Arch, ortop, Milano, 1928, 44: 497-534.—De Lucchi, G. Indagini sui rapporti fra artrite deformante dell'anca e displasia congenita. Chir. org. movim, 1939-40, 25: 17-24.—Dijkstra, O. H, & Mol, W. [Structure of the femoral head in arthritis deformans of hip-joint] Ned. tschr. geneesk, 1930, 74: pt 2, 5267-77, 2 pl.—Duvernay, L. Qu'est-ce que le morbus coxae senilis? Acta chir. scand, 1930, 67: 308-12.—Elmslie, R. C. Aetiological factors in osteo- arthritis of the hip-joint. Brit. M. J, 1933, 1: 1-3. Faldini, G. Artrite deformante dell'anca da ferita di arma da fuoeo; infiltrazione metallica della sinoviale. Chir. org. movim, 1925-26, 10: 586-92.—Ferey, D. Trois observations de lesions aneiennes des trompes et des ovaires traitees pour coxalgie ou arthrite chronique coxo-femorale. Bull, med. Par, 1937, 51: 158-60.—Fletcher, E. Osteoarthritis of the hips associated with coxa plana. Proc. R. Soc. M, Lond, 1938-39, 32: Clin. Sect, 1386.—Giuliani, G. M. Osteo- artrite deformante dell'anca secondaria a lussazione traumatica coxo-femorale con interessamento dello sciatico. Chir. org. movim, 1932-33, 17: 521-36.—Giuntini, L. Osteo-artrite dell'anca in luetico. Atti Soc. lombard. sc. med, 1927, 16: 60-9.—Gordon, R. G. Osteo-arthritis and its concomitants. Lancet, Lond, 1935, 2: 1005.—Hertzell. Bericht uber den einjiihrigen Verlauf einer Selbsterkrankung an Arthritis deformans der Hiifte nach Sportverletzung. Verh. Deut. orthop. Ges. (1927) 1928, 22. Kongr, 186-90.—Herzog, A. Scheinfrakturen bei der Arthritis deformans coxae. Ront- genpraxis, 1933, 5: 174-7.—Japiot, P. Arthrite deformante de la hanche consecutive k une ancienne osteomyeiite du tibia; diagnostic radiographique. Rev. internat. med. chir., Par, 1918, 29: 60.—Josselin de Jong, R. de. Ueber das Malum coxae senile und iiber die Plastizitat des Knochengewebes. Virchows Arch, 1930, 275: 348-72.—Lieben, A. Beitrag zur Kenntnis der Entstehung, der Klinik und Behandlung der Arthritis deformans des Hiiftgelenkes. Miinch. med. Wschr, 1933, 80: 810-13.—Ory. De quelques cas debutants d'osteo- arthrite de la hanche. Ann. Soc. med. chir. Liege, 1934, 67: 103-6.—Radcliffe-Taylor, M. A. The pathology of osteo- arthritis of the hip joint as seen at operation. Med. J. Australia, 1927, 2: Suppl, 306-9.—Rendall, S. M. Reflexes and muscular atrophies in arthritis deformans of the hip joint. Practitioner, Lond, 1928, 121: 121-30.—Seara, L. Artritis deformante de la cadera por luxaci6n. Rev. As. med. argent, 1937, 51: 135.—Sorrel, E. Les foyers d'osteoporose de la tete et du rebord cotyloidien dans les arthrites deformantes de la hanche. Mem. Acad. chir.. Pai.. 1937, 63: 399-404.—Sosa de Quesada, U. Un caso inteievmte de osteoartritis tifica de la cadera. Cir. ortop. traumat, Habana, 1939, 7: 27-33.—Stolzner, H. Ueber die Arthritis deformans der Hufte unter besonderer Berucksichtigung ihrer Aetiologie und der Frage der Kriegs- dienstbesehiidigung. Aerztl. Mschr, 1928, 193: 225.—Treves, A. Osteo-arthrites de la hanche a evolution anormale. Bull. Soc. pediat. Paris, 1928, 36: 282-4.—Vallone, D. Contributo clinico ed anatomopatologico all'artrite deformante dell'anca. Riforma med, 1929, 45: 662-7.—Weil, M. P, & Polak, C. Rapport sur les conditions generatrices de l'osteo-arthrite de la hanche. Rev. rhumat. Par, 1935, 2: 694-708. Also Gaz. med. France, 1936, 43: 305-8.—Zanoli. R. Lesioni cotiloidee dell'osteo-artrite deformante dell'anca. Atti Congr. ital. radiol. med, 1928, 8: pt 2, 35-7. ---- Osteoarthritis: Treatment. Barthet.mes, H. *Ueber Erfahrungen mit der operativen Behandlung der chronisch deformie- renden Huftgelenkserkrankung [Frankfurt] 23p. 8° Wertheim, 1936. Benoist, D. *Contributjon aux indications ft aux techniques chirurgicales dans le traite- ment des arthrites deformantes de la hanche. 126p. 8° Par., 1936. Klopfer, F. *Die unblutige Umstellung in Narkose bei schweren Fallen von Arthrosis deformans der Hiifte [Munchen] 30p. 8°. Kallmiinz, 1934. Bailey, E. T., & Burrows, H. J. Nail fixation of osteo- arthritic hip without exposure of joint. Lancet, Lond, 1939, I: 980-3.—Bankart, A. S. B. Excision of head of femur in arthritis deformans. Brit. M. J, 1922, 1: 730.—Blixenkrone- Moller, N. Treatment of arthritis deformans of the hip by resection of the obturator nerve. Acta orthop. scand, 1940, 11: 11-30.—Blundell, A. S. Chordotomy in the treatment of osteoarthritis of the hip. Lancet, Lond, 1929, 2: 378-80.— Boppe. A propos du traitement chirurgical de l'osteoarthrite chronique degenerative de la hanche. Rev. rhumat. Par, 1935, 2: 716-8.—Burns, B. H. Fixation of the osteo-arthritic hip by nailing. Lancet, Lond, 1939, 1: 978-80.—Camitz, H. Die deformierende Hiiftgelenksarthritis und speziell ihre Behandlung. Acta orthop. scand, 1933, 4: 193-213.—Charry, R, & Charry, G. Arthrite deformante de la hanche chez une femme de 52 ans, echec partiel du forage, amelioration complete aprSs osteotomie et butee compiementaires. Bull. Soc. chir. Paris, 1938, 30: 303-8.—Ciaccia, S. Nuovo metodo di cura dell'artrite deformante deU'anca. Arch, ortop, Milano, 1934, 50: 281-90.—Contargyris, A. Arthrodese extra-articulaire de la hanche pour arthrite chronique deformante douloureuse. Bordeaux chir, 1932, 3: 473.—Crowe, H. W. Osteo-arthritis of the hip-joint treated by vaccines. Brit. M. J, 1926, 2: 834, pl.—Dueno, F. P. La artritis deformante de cadera y su tratamiento. Arch, med, Madr, 1935, 38: 645-58.—Dujarier, C. Arthrite deformante de la hanche; operation de Whitman; guerison. Bull. Soe. nat. chir. Par, 1928, 54: 1392-4.— Finochietto, R. Artritis deformante eoxofemoral; tecnica de la anestesia local para la perforation del cuello. Sem. med, B. Air, 1937, 44: 1421.—Goldberg, H. Operation for bilateral osteo-arthritis of the hip. J. Bone Surg, 1934, 16: 721-4.— Groves, E. W. H. Surgical treatment of osteo-arthritis of the hip. Brit. M. J, 1933, 1: 3-5.—Hamant, Rodard & Chalnot. Arthrite deformante de la hanche traitee par resection. Rev. med. est, 1932, 60: 778-80.—Hass, J. Palliativ-operative Behandlung der Arthritis deformans der Hiifte. Zbl. Chir, 1927, 54: 2958-62.—Henderson, M. S, & Pollock, G. A. Surgical treatment of osteo-arthritis of the hip joint. Collect. Papers Mayo Clin, 1931, 31: 601-10. Also J. Bone Surg, 1940, 22: 923-31.—Hohmann. Eine neue Bandage fiir die chronisch- deformierende Gelenkentziindung des Huftgelenks. Miinch. med. Wschr, 1932, 72: 49-51.—Hohmann, G. Zur Ursache und Behandlung des Malum coxae senile. Med. Welt, 1940, 14: 885, pl.—Hybbinette, S. Mes resultats operatoires dans I'arthrite deformante de la hanche. P. verb. Congr. fr. chir, 1932, 41: 745-66. ------ Experiences d'operations d'apies Graber-Duvernay pour I'arthrite deformante de la hanche. Rev. rhumat. Par, 1935, 2: 732-6. ------ Quelques mots sur des cas d'arthrite deformante de la hanche traites par forage d'apres le procede de Graber-Duvernay. C. rend. Congr. internat. rhumat. (1936) 1938, 5. Congr, 197-200. ------Resultats consecutifs a une arthroplastie pour arthrite deformante de la hanche. J. internat. chir, Brux, 1937, 2: 81-91.—Jensen, E. [Osteoarthritis deformans coxae; observa- tions on the disease and new method of treatment] Hospitals- tidende, 1935, 78: [Jydsk. med. selsk. forh.] 97.—Lambotte, A. L'arthroplastie de la hanche dans I'arthrite deformante. Presse med.-, 1933, 41: 6.—Lance. Arthrodese extra-articulaire de la hanche pour arthrite chronique deformante douloureusse. Bull. Soc. nat. chir. Par, 1928, 54: 1023-5.—Malkin, S. A. S. Femoral osteotomy in treatment of osteo-arthritis of the hip. Brit. M. J, 1936, 1: 304.—Maragliano, D, & Picetti, G. La cura chirurgica dell'osteo-sirtrite deformante deU'anca. Ri- forma med, 1938, 54: 1855.—Massart, R. Les coxo-femoro- plasties dans le traitement fonctionnel du morbus coxae senilis. Bull. Soc. chir. Paris, 1939, 31: 143-7. Also Rev. rhumat. Par, 1939, 6: 259; 555.------& Vidal-Naquet, G. La valeur du forage dans le traitement des arthrites deformantes de la hanche, d'apres 23 observations personnelles. Ibid, 1935, 2: 720-6.—■ Mathieu, P. Traitement chirurgical des arthrites deformantes de la hanche chez l'adulte. Gaz. hop, 1931, 104: 1833-40. ------ Indications chirurgicales dans le traitement des arthrites deformantes de la hanche. J. med. chir. Par, 1932, 103: 761-6. ------ Rapport sur le traitement orthopedique et chirurgical des arthrites deformantes de la hanche. Rev. rhumat. Par, 1935, 2: 605-34.—Merle d'Aubigne, R, & Ingelrans, P. Arthrite deformante de la hanche; resection arthroplastique; resection arthroplastique de la hanche pour arthrite chronique consecutive a une luxation traumatique reduite. Bull. Soc. nat. chir. Par, 1935, 61: 1234-8— Mol, W. [Resection of the obturator nerve in arthritis deformans of the hip-joint] Ned. tschr. geneesk, 1935, 79: 850-5, pl.— Padovani, P. A propos de la technique et des resultats du forage du col femoral dans le traitement de I'arthrite chronique deformante de la hanche. Rev. med. fr, 1938, 19: 555-9.— Pancrazio, F, & Mazzoni, E. II malum coxae senile (osteo- artrite deformante deU'anca) sotto il punto di vista medico e in rapporto alle cure termali. Gazz. osp, 1937, 58: 755-7. Also Riv. idroclim, 1939, 50: 161-7.—Pieri, G. Sur le traitement operatoire de I'arthrite deformante de la hanche. P. verb. Congr. fr. chir.. 1932, 41: 769. Also Arch. ital. chir, 1933, 34: 457-95.—Piatt, H. The surgical treatment of osteo- arthritis of the. hip-joint. Lancet, Lond, 1927, 1: 147.— Putti, V. Treatment of arthritis deformans of the hip. Internat. Clin, 1928, 38. ser, 4: 1-11.—Reichart. Zur Behandlung der Arthritis deformans coxae. Munch, med. Wschr, 1934, 81: 509.—Rocher, H. L. A propos de la technique du forage de l'extremite superieure du femur dans les osteo-arthrites defor- mantes de la hanche. Bordeaux chir, 1932, 3: 478. —---- Le forage de l'extremite superieure du femur, dans les arthrites chroniques deformantes de la hanche, de l'adulte. Ibid., 526- 31.—Rollo, S. Contributo alia cura chirurgica dell'artrite deformante dell'anca. Arch. ital. chir, 1935, 39: 900.— Simpson, W. C. Painful osteo-arthritis of the hip: a surgical treatment. Proc. Mayo Clin, 1937, 12: 577-81—Slot, G. HIP-JOINT 698 HIP-JOINT A note on the treatment of osteo-arthritis of the hip. Prac- titioner, Lond, 1936, 136: 212.- Tormier Du traitement des arthrites deformantes de la hanche. P. verb. Congr. fr. chir, 1932, 41: 825-7. Thomsen, W. Zur Behandlung der Arthrosis deformans des Hiiftgelenks. Zschr. Rheumaforsch, 1938, 1: 127-32—Treves, A. Le forage dans les osteo-arthrites de la hanche. Rev. rhumat., Par, 1935, 2: 718-20.------& Vidal-Naquet, G. A propos du traitement chirurgical de I'arthrite chronique deformante de la hanche. Progr. med. Par, 1935, 1041-7.—Venezian, E. Artrodesi extrarticolare nell'artrite deformante deU'anca. Arch, ortop, Milano, 1932, 48: 277-84.—Vidal-Naquet, G. Que peut-on attendre du forage dans I'arthrite chronique deformante de la hanche. J. med. Paris, 1936. 56: 263-5.—Watson-Jones, R. Arthrodesis of the osteoarthritic hip. J. Am. M. Ass, 1938, 110: 278-80.— Woolf, A. E. M. Osteo-arthritis of the right hip, treated with an extra-articular bone graft; osteo-arthritis of the right knee, treated with auto-fat injection. Proc. R. Soc. M, Lond, 1936- 37, 30: 757.—Zeno, L. O. Reconstrucci6n de cadera por artritis deformante; consideraciones sobre la etiopatogenia del reuma- tLsmo cr6nico. Rev. cir. B. Aires, 1930, 9: 486-94. ---- Osteomyelitis. See also Hip, Osteomyelitis; Hip-joint, Coxitis, infectious. Brtjhl, R. C. *Die Epiphysenosteomyelitis mit besonderer Berucksichtigung des Huftgelenks 8p. 8? Bonn, 1922. Roos, W. *Ein Beitrag zur akuten Hiift- gelenksosteomyelitis. 14p. 8? Giessen, 1925. >Scheel, H. [L. R.] *Ueber Osteomyelitis am Hiiftgelenk. 42p. 8? Berl., 1926. Fridmanas, J. [Hematogenous osteomyelitis of the neck of the femur in children] Medicina, Kaunas, 1941, 22: 55-79.— Fruchaud, H, it Peignaux. Arthrites aigues osteomyeiitiques de la hanche chez le nourrisson. Arch. med. chir. province, 1930, 20: 111-9.—Gold, E. Ueber die akute septische Koxitis des friihen Kindesalters (Sauglingsosteomyelitis des Hiift- gelenkes) und deren Behandlung vom funktionell-anntomischen Gesichtspunkt. Zschr. orthop. Chir, 1929, 52: .153-74.— Lepoutre & David. Arthrite purulente de la hatielie, osteo- myeiite, chez un jeune homme de 10 ans; guerison par simple arthrotomie. J. se. med. Lille. 1930. 48: :i(»0-3— Mark, G. Extraartikulare Osteomvelitis im Bereiche des Hiift srelenkes. Schweiz. med. Wschr, 1937, 67:636.— Mark6,D. Zur Rontgen- diagnostik der Coxitis osteomyelitica. Rontgenpraxis, 1929, 1: 163-72.—Moss, W. Osteomyelitis of the upper end of the femur; description of a diagnostic sign. N. Orleans M. & S. J, 1939-40, 92: 569-72.—Neuman, F. T. [Osteomyelitic coxitis in children] Sovet. vrach. gaz, 1932, 36: 597.—Partsch, C. Osteomyelitis des Huftgelenks. Beitr. klin. Chir, 1926, 137: 756-63. ---- Physiology. Faber. Ueber funktionelle Anpassung im Hiiftgelenk. Verh. Deut. orthop. Ges. (1934) 1935, 29: 137-41.—Kuhns, J. G. Pelvic inclination in relation to stability of the hip joint. Physiother. Rev, 1935, 15: 16-8.—Ombredanne, L. La hanche pendant la station et pendant la marche. In Traite chir. orthop. (Ombredanne) Par, 1937, 4: 3007-25.—Thomsen, W. Zur Statik und Mechanik der gesunden und gelahmten Hiifte; zur Anatomie des Duchenne-Trendelenburgschen Ph-inomens. Zschr. orthop. Chir, 1933, 60: 25-44. ------ Ueber die Bedeutung der Rumpfmuskulatur far die Statik und Mechanik der Huftgelenke. Ibid, 1934-35, 62: 21-64.— Timmer, H. Mechanical explanation of the equilibrium of the hip joint while standing on one leg, and the description of the apparatus which demonstrated this explanation] Ned. tschr. geneesk, 1940. 84: 1550-5.—Watermann. Form und Funktion der Huftgelenksgabelung. Verh. Deut. orthop. Ges. (1935) 1936, 30. Kongr, 79-82. ---- Pseudoarthrosis. See also Hip, Femoral neck: Fracture, un- united. Camitz, H. *Die Pseudarthrosen nach medi- alen Frakturen des Collum femoris und deren Behandlung. 108p. 8? Stockh., 1931. Ftjnck-Brentano, L. P. A. Les pseud- arthroses du col du femur. 296p. 8? Par., 1930. Hansen, J. [K. D.] *Pseudarthrose des Schenkelhalses als Folgezustand einer Epiphy- senlosung bei Osteomvelitis purulenta [Miinchen] 17p. 8? Wiirzb., 1934. Hecart, J. L. M. Contribution a l'etude anatomo-clinique et au traitement des pseud- arthroses du col du femur [Paris] 91n 8° Blois, 1936. Martin-Barhaz, J. *Contribution a l'etude du traitement des pseudarthroses du col du femur [Lyon] 156p. 8? Bourg, 1935. Richard, AI. *Die Pseudarthrosenbildung am Sehenkelhals und ihre Behandlung [Basel] 17p 8? Lpz., 1925. Also Zschr. Chir, 1925, 190: 344-58. Rust, T. *Ueber Pseudarthrosen nach Schen- kelhalsfrakturen; ein Beitrag zur Entwicklungs- mechanik [Basel] 95p. 23cm. Zug, 193S. Schweicher, B. M. *Die Schcnkcllitils- pseudarthrose und Spiiterfolge der Pauwels'sehen Sehenkelhalsumlagcrung bei Pseudarthrosebil- dung [Munchen] 25p. 22cm. Diisseld., 1937. Wirtz, PI. *Dic Schenkelhalsfraktur unci ihre Pseudarthrose unler besonderer Beriick- sichtigung der Pauwels'sehen Abwinkelungs- osteotomic. 42p. 8? Munster. 1934. Basset, A. Fractures et pseudarthroses du col du femur In Oeuvre (Delbet, P.) Par, 1932, 393-412- Hastos y Ansart] M. Sobre el tratamiento de las pseudartrosis del cuello dei femur por el metodo de Alb^e. Progr. clin, Madr, 1920, |5: 140-52.—Berard, M. A propos des pseudarthroses du col du femur. Lyon chir, 1937, 34: 08-71.- Bonier. I, HeliandluiiR der Schenkelhalspseudarthrose mit Nagelung. beziehunirsweise Umstellung der Belastung. Wien. med. Wsehr, 1935, 85: 40. ------ Behandlung von veralteten Schenkelhalsbruchen und von Sehenkelhalspseudarthrosen. Zbl. Chir, 1935, 62: 1756-67.—Boppe, M. Le traitement des pseudarthroses du col du femur. Rev. crit. path. Par, 1930, 2: 351-8. ----- Pseudarthrose du col femoral consecutive k une coxa-vara dite de I'enfance ou a fissure verticale. Mem. Acad, chir. Par 1936, 62: 1324-6. ------ & Hecard, J. Le traitement dea pseudarthroses du col du femur. Presse med, 1936, 44: 2103- 5.—Brandes. Spiitresultate nach der Pauwettschen Operation der Schenkelhalspseudarthrose. Verh. Deut. orthop. Ges, 30. Kongr. (1935) 1930, 431-4.—Brekke. A. Pseudarthrosis colli femoris. Acta chir. scand, 1935, 76: 352-60, pl.—-Charry, R., & Charry, G. Greffe transcervicale pour pseudarthrose du col du femur chez une fillette de 12 ans. Rev. orthop. Par, 1938, 3. ser, 25: 52-5.—Dupuy de Frenelle. Traitement de la pseudarthrose du col du f6mur par l'operation k ciel ouvert et par la greffe homoplastique. P. verb. Congr. fr. chir, 1923, 32: 729.—Felsenreich, F. Wie entstehen Pseudarthrosen und andere Misserfolge nach Nagelung medialer Schenkelhals- bruche? Zbl. Chir, 1936, 63: 2843-58. ------ Vorlaufer und Vorstadien der Sehenkelhalspseudarthrosen nach medialen und lateralen Frakturen. Arch. klin. Chir, 1938-39, 194: 90-134.—Freund, E. Histologie der Nearthrose nach Sehenkel- halsbriichen. Beitr. path. Anat, 1930, 85: 101-44.— Funck- Brcntano, P. Symptomes et indications operatoires des pseudarthroses du col du f6mur. Bull, med. Par, 1930, 44: 839-43. ------ Causes et traitement des pseudarthroses du col du femur. J. chir. Par, 1931, 38: 666-85.----- & Couvelaire, R. Pseudarthrose du col du femur par interposition du tendon du muscle obturateur externe. Ann. anat. path. Par, 1933, 10: 322-4.—Garcia Diaz. F. Tratamiento de las fracturas y seudoartrosis del cuello de femur (leccion corres- pondiente al curso sobre tratamiento prrfctico de las frac- turas) Progr. clin, Madr, 1933, 41: 295-300.—Gatellier, J, & D'Aubigne, M. L'arthrotomie de la hanche par le procede d'Ollier modifie; application au traitement des pseudarthroses du col du femur. J. chir. Par, 1931, 38: 24-37.—Guibal & Bardin. AthrodSse extraarticulaire pour pseudarthrose du col. Rev. med. Nancy, 1939, 67: 233-7.—Guidal, P. L'osteotomie sous-trochanterienne dans les pseudarthroses du col du femur. Bordeaux chir, 1933, 4: 410. Also J. med. Bordeaux, 1933, 110: 739-43.—Hartmann. Pseudarthroses consecutives k des fractures du col du f6mur. Rev. gin. clin. ther, 1928. 42: 659.— Hillebrand, H. Ein weiterer Beitrag zur Behandlung der Schenkelhalspseudarthrose: Abwinkelung nach Pauwels. Beitr. klin. Chir, 1933, 157: 281-5.—Hoffmann, R. La fracture la plus rebelle; considerations sur les fractures et pseudoarthroses du col du femur. Rev. orthop. Par, 1938, 3. ser, 25: 193- 204.—Inclan, A. La reconstrucci6n de la cadera en el trata- miento de las pseudoartrosis con reabsorciAn del cuello del femur. An. cirug, Habana, 1930, 2: 284-50.—Iselin, H. Zer- stdrung des Schenkelhalses durch Wander-Pseudarthrose und sein Wiederaufbau; probleme der Entwicklungs-Mechanik (Roux) Schweiz. med. Wschr, 1938, 68: 472-6.—Jauregui, P. Pseudo-artrosis del cuello femoral tratadas por el metodo Delbet-Girode. Bol. Soc. cir. B. Aires, 1928, 12: 169-75 — Jianu, A, & Popesco, C. Le traitement"des pseudoarthroses du col f6moral par l'application du clou de Smith-Petersen. Rev. chir, Bucur, 1941, 44: 252-7.—Johansson, S. A case of pseudarthrosis of the neck of the femur, treated by the method of extra-articular osteosynthesis. Acta orthop. scand, 1933,4: 214-8.—La Chapelle, E. H, & Justesen, V. [Pseudoarthrosis colli femoris] Ned. tsehr. geneesk, 1939, 83: 1907-16 — Lagouttc & Rousselin, L. A propos des pseudarthroses du col du femur. Lyon chir, 1933, 30: 342-7.—Ling, A. Zur Frage der nach Oberschenkelhalsfrakturen entstandenen Pseudar- throsen. Opera Internat. Congr. Indust. Accid. (1928) 1929, HIP-JOINT 699 HIP-JOINT 5. Congr, 287.—Lange, F. Die Bolzung der Schenkelhals- pseudarthrose. Zschr. orthop. Chir, 1932-33, 58: 204-10.— Lange, M. Die Gefahr der Pseudarthrosenbildung und Femurkopfnekrose nach Sehenkelhals- und Schenkelkopf- briichen Jugendlicher. Ibid, 1932, 57: 531-43.—Leoni Iparraguirre, C. A. Seudartrosis del cuello femoral. Dfa med, B. Air, 1941, 13: 17-21.—Leveuf, J. A propos du traitement des pseudarthroses du col du femur. Presse med, 1931, 39: 204-6.—Luck, J. V. A reconstruction operation for pseudar- throsis and resorption of the neck of the femur. J. Iowa M. Soc, 1938, 28: 620-2.—Malpractice; fibrous union following fracture of hip. J. Am. M. Ass, 1936,106:1685.—Mandruzzato, F. Osteotomia intertrocanterica nella pseudoartrosi per frat- ture del collo femorale. Chir. org. movim, 1939-40, 25: 417- 26.—Mathieu, P. Indications de la resection arthroplastique de la hanche pour certaines pseudarthroses du col femoral. Bull. Soc. nat. chir. Par, 1934, 60: 222-5. Pseudarthroses du col du femur. In Traite chir. orthop. (Ombredanne) Par, 1937, 4: 3304-25. ------ Le traitement des pseudarthroses du col du femur. Arch. ital. chir, 1938, 53: 1-7. ------ & Padovani, P. Indications de la resection arthroplastique de la hanche pour certaines pseudarthroses du col femoral. Gaz. med. France, 1934, 447-50.—Niethammer, G. Ein bemerkenswerter Fall von akzessorischer Hiiftgelenks- bildung bei einem Barasingha-Hirsch. Virchows Arch, 1931, 281: 932-42.—Papin, E. Methodes nouvelles de traitement des fractures et pseudarthroses du col du femur. J. med. Bordeaux, 1938, 115: pt 2, 257; 297.—Patel, M. Au sujet du traitement des pseudarthroses du col femoral. P. verb. Congr. fr. chir, 1930,39:409-11. Also Paris chir, 1930, 22: 180-8. Also Lyon chir, 1936, 33: 745-50.—Pautel, M. Au sujet du traitement des pseudarthroses du col femoral. Arch. fr. belg. chir, 1929- 30, 32: 509.—Pauwels, F. Eine neue Methode zur operativen Behandlung der Schenkelhalspseudarthrose. Zschr. orthop. Chir, 1929, 51: 125-34.—Peschard, J. A. Neoartrosis femoro- ilfaca. Gac. med. Mexico, 1942, 72: 93-8.—Putti, V. L'osteo- tomie intertrochanterienne dans le traitement des pseudar- throses du col du femur. Presse med, 1937, 45: 1841-3.— Re, C. Autoplastiche ossee nelle pseudartrosi del collo del femore. Arch, ortop, Milano, 1936, 52: 689-713.—Rendu, A. R6sultat eloigne d'une arthrodese extraarticulaire de la hanche pour une ancienne coxalgie k pseudarthrose intra-eotvlo'idienne. Rey. orthop. Par, 1927, 14: 705-7.—Rocher, H. L.. & Pou- yanne, L. Coxalgie gauche; pseudarthrose intra-cotyloidienne; arthrodese extra-articulaire minima apres 4 ans devolution; guerison par ankylose osseuse. J. med. Bordeaux, 1938, 115: pt 2, 626-8.—Rousseau, G, & Adamesteanu. C. Considera- tions sur les causes de la production des pseudarthroses dans les fractures transcervicales du col du femur. Presse med, 1935, 43: 1940-2.—Satanowsky, S. Tratamiento de la seudo- artrosis del cuello femoral, por la osteotomia intertrocanterica. Sem. med, B. Air, 1939, 46: pt 2, 602-6.—Schmidt, A. Histo- logische Untersuchungen bei Pseudarthrose nach medialer Schenkelhalsfraktur. Beitr. klin. Chir, 1926, 138": 305-24.— Sickmann, J. H. Ein Beitrag zur Pauwelsschen subtro- chanteren Keilosteotomie bei der Schenkelhalspseudarthrose. Deut. Zschr. Chir, 1930, 229: 336-42— Sitterli, A. Ein Bei- trag zur operativen Spatbehandlung einer Pseudarthrosis colli femoris. Zschr. Orthop, 1938-39, 69: 490.—Stewart, W. J. Pseudo-arthrosis of the hip following acute infection of the joint. Ann. Surg, 1934, 99: 515.— Stulz, E, & Fontaine, R. Un cas de pseudarthrose du col femoral traite par l'encheville- ment. Strasbourg med, 1926, 84: pt 2, 44.—Tavernier, L. L'osteosynthese k ciel ouvert dans les pseudarthroses du col du femur. Bull. Soc. nat. chir. Par, 1927, 53: 987-92.—Tavernier, M. Traitement des pseudarthroses du col du femur. Lyon chir, 1937, 34: 60-4.—Treves, A. Pseudarthrose consecutive k une fracture meconnue du col du femur. Paris chir, 1926, 18: 202. ------ L'osteotomie sous-trochanterienne en console, dans les pseudarthroses du col du femur. Bordeaux chir, 1932, 3: 475.—Vails Marin. Pseudartrosis de cuello de femur. Med. ibera, 1935, 29: 19.—Villaran, C. Pseudoartrosis extra- articular laxa; curaci6n por artrodesis; nuevo procedimiento. An. Clin, quir, Lima, 1938-39, 1: 84-91.—Zander, P. Trata- mento da pseudo-arthrose da fractura do collo do femur. Rev. brasil. cir, 1939, 8: 367-78.—Zeno, L. Seudoartrosis del cuello del femur; osteosintesis extra-articular. Bol. Soc. cir. B. Aires, 1938, 22: 120-8. Also Cir. ortop. traumat, Habana, 1938, 6: 3-13. --- Radiography. See also Hip, Examination. Lagree, F. Contribution k l'etude du dia- gnostic radiographique des maladies de la hanche. 66p. 8? Par., 1929. Bardet, P. La determination1 des centres articulaires de la hanche. Bull. Soc. radiol. med. France, 1934, 22: 99- 101.------Une cause d'erreur dans l'exploration radio- graphique d'une hanche. Radiol. Rdsch, 1938. 7: 254.------ & Perrot. A. Les centres articulaires de la hanche; nouveau procede pour l'etude radiologique de la statique articulaire de la hanche. J. radiol. electr, 1934, 18: 361-75.—Bauer, F. Rontgenbefunde des jungen Hiiftgelenkes bei Funktion und funktioneller Behandlung seiner Ausrenkung. Fortsch. Roentgenstrahl, 1937, 56: 122-6.—Beclere, H, & Porcher, P. La radiographic laterale de la hanche. J. radiol. electr, 1926, 10: 97-105.—Bellone, A. La cavite sinoviale dell'articolazione coxo-femorale nell uomo studiata col metodo radiologico. Arch. radiol. Nap, 1939, 15: 629-35.-Chasin, A. Analysed* iq£g48 Ron QdneS huftgelenks. Fortsch. Roentgenstrahl, 1933, 48: 620-30.—Cleaves, E. N. Observations on lateral views of hips Am. J. Roentg, 1938, 39: 964-6.—Danelius, G, te Miller, L. F. Lateral view of the hip. Ibid, 1936, 35: 282- 4. Also X-ray Technician, 1937-38, 9: 176-8.—Douglas J J lurther notes on hip technic. Ibid, 1938-39, 10: 134 — fc-rlacher, P J Eine zweite Rontgenaufnahme des Hiift- gelenkes Zbl. Chir, 1935, 62: 731-5.-Faber. Das Rontgen- Moo^noi^o1?11^1361111 fugling. Verh. Deut. orthop. Ges. (1937) 1938, 32. Kongr, 251-8.------Ergebnisse von Koiitgenkontrastuntersuchungen am Hiiftgelenk Munch med. Wschr, 1939, 86: 1656.—Friedman, L. J. Laterai roentgen-ray study of the hip joint. Radiology, 1936, 27- 240.—Glauner, R. Ueber Aufhellungsherde im Rontgenbild des Huftgelenks. Rontgenpraxis, 1938, 10: 361-76 —Gr Ivindliches Hiiftgelenk, Normalstudie. Ibid, 1934, 6: 819.— Grasser, C. H. Hilfsmethoden zur Darstellung des Hiift- gelenkes und des Schenkelhalses. Ibid, 1938, 10: 544-51 — Hackenbroch, M. Zur Frage der Aufhellungsherde im Rontgenbild des Hiiftgelenks. Zschr. Orthop, 1939, 70: 115- 24 —Herzog, A. Zur Pathologie des Hiiftgelenkes im Rontgen- bild. Ibid, 1934, 61: 156-68.—Johnson, J. B, & Anspach, H. M. Early roentgenologic signs in some of the more common disorders of the hip. South. M. J, 1939, 32: 1228-35.— Kaplan, I. W. A wood tunnel for serial roentgenograms in internal fixation of the hip. Am. J. Surg, 1940, 47: 167-9.— Kevesh, E. L. [Rontgen examination of the hip-joint and neck of femur in lateral projection] Vest, rentg, 1937, 18: 71-3.—Lacaze, H. P., & Chaumet, G. J. Ce qu'il est possible de demander k la radiologic pour le diagnostic des affections chirurgicales de la hanche. Arch. med. pharm. mil, 1928, 88: 341-82.—Lewin, P. An unusual roentgenographic finding in the hip. Am. J. Roentg, 1928, 19: 290.—Lloyd, P. T. The hip joint; a roentgenologic consideration of some of the pathologic states common to it. J. Am. Osteopath. Ass, 1940-41, 40: 109-12.—Ludloff, K. Die vielseitige VerwertBaTkeit des Trendelenburgsehen Phiinomens fiir die Diagnostik der Affek- tionen des Hiiftgelenkes und des Beckens. Klin. Wschr, 1934, 13: 469-74.—Manfredi, M., & Swenson, P. C. Lateral roentgenography of the hip. Am. J. Roentg, 1935, 34: 404.— Moreau. Stereoradiographie de la hanche normale et pathologi- que. Arch, electr. med, 1927, 37: 14-6, 4 pl—Morrison. L. B. A study of the hip joint from the standpoint of the roentgen- ologist. Am. J. Roentg, 1932, 28: 484-520.—Pletz, F. Lateral roentgenography of the hip. X-ray Technician, 1936-37, 8: 60.—Roederer. La radiographic de profil de la hanche. Bull. Soc. chir, Paris, 1928, 20: 771-4.—Severin, E. Arthrograms of hip joints of'children. Surg. Gyn. Obst, 1941, 72: 601-4.— Sokolowski, T. [New method of Roentgen examination of the hip-joint and superior epiphysis of the femur] Lek. wojsk, 1936, 27: 686-93, 10 pl.—Teufel, S. Eine gezielte Aufsichts- aufnahme der Hiiftgelenkspfanne. Rontgenpraxis, 1938, 10: 398-402.—Trzaskowski, S. [Technique in roentgen examination of the hip-joint] Polski przegl. radjol, 1937, 12: 27-36, pl.— Winderlich. Rontgenologische Demonstrationen aus dem Gebiete des kindlichen Huftgelenkes. Zbl. Chir, 1939, 66: 2208. ---- snapping. Elte, W. [F.] *Das schnellende Hiift- und Knicgelenk unter besonderer Berucksichtigung der Aeliologie und Mechanik [Halle] 31p. 8? Bleicherode, 1936. Bernsten, A. [Coxa saltans] Ugeskr. laeger, 1941, 103: 327.—Cotte, G. Hanche ballante traitee par reposition sang- lante avec capsulorraphie; resultat eloigne de 12 ans. Lyon chir, 1932, 29: 748.—Dickinson, A. M. Bilateral snapping hip. Am. J. Surg, 1929, n. ser, 6: 97-101.—Dominici, L. L'anca a scatto; ricerche cliniche ed anatomiche. Bull. Accad. med. Roma, 1927, 53: 217-31. Also Chir. org. movim, 1928, 12: 209-75.—Dupuy de Frenelle. Traitement operatoire de la hanche flottante par la refection du ligament rond. P. verb. Congr. fr. chir, 1936, 45: 821-6. ■----- Traitement opera- toire de la hanche flottante par la greffe d'un puissant ligament rond qui fixe solidement la tete femorale contre le fond de la cavite cotyloide. Techn. chir. Par, 1937, 29: 93-116.— Engelke, O. Schnappende Hufte bei einem Beinamputierten. Arch, orthop. UnfaUchir, 1932-33, 32: 61-9.—Godoy Moreira, F. E. Anca a scatto. Chir. org. movim, 1938-39, 24: 381-3.— Guibal, J, & Rousseaux. La hanche a ressort est un symptome; son mecanisme pathogenique. Paris med, 1929, 7:1 460-4.— Hilgenreiner, H. Ein Fall von schnappender Hiifte im ersten Lebensjahre. Beitr. klin. Chir, 1929, 147: 210-6.—Nitsche, F. Zur Therapie der schnellenden Hiifte. Zbl. Chir, 1934, 61: 901.—Nutter, J. A. A case of snapping hip with operative cure. Canad. M. Ass. J, 1927, 17: 693.—Olascoaga, M.L. Clownis- mo congenito y cadera a resorte. Prensa med. argent, 1939,26: 3g.)_g —Rocher, H. L. Hanche k ressort extra-articulaire bilaterale. Bordeaux chir, 1936, 7: 429.—Stotz, W. Die Bedeutung der Psychotherapie fiir die Bewertung der schnellen- den Hiifte bei Unfallverletzten. Zbl. Chir, 1936, 63: 2706- 9 —Suermondt, W. F. Doppelseitige schnellende Hiifte. Deut. Zschr. Chir, 1933-34, 242: 792-6.—Taddei, D. Sopra un caso di anca a scatto dolorosa. Gior. med. prat, 1933, 15: 191- 204.—Thomsen, W. Zur Statik und Mechanik der gesunden HIP-JOINT 700 HIP-JOINT und gelahmten HOfte; uber die Bedeutung des Trait us ilio- iii.iilis (Maissiat) Zschr. orthop. Chir, 1933, 60: 212 -31.— Weber. L. A. La cadera de resorte; trocanter a resaltos. Rev. ortop. traumat, B. Air., 1936-37, 6: 301-19. ---- Surgery. Albee, F. H. Evolucao da cirurgia da articulaciio coxo- femural. Rev. brasil. cir, 1939, 8: 23-0. —Allende, G. Vias de acceso a la articulaci6n de hi cadera. Rev. ortop. traumat, B. Air, 1932-33, 2: 1-51.—Allison, N. Les voies d'acces sur la hanche. Bull. Soc. chir. Paris. 1928. 20: 430-43. Also Paris chir, 1928, 20: 1.17-23.—Ashhurst, A. P. C. Operative surgery of the hip joint. Rapp. Congr. Soc. internat. chir, 1929-30. 8. Congr., 1: 939-78. Also Arch. Surg, 1930, 20: 87-144.— (alve, J. Voie d'acces trans-trochanterienne sur la fosse ilifiiiue externe dans les operations osteo-plastiques de la hanche; l.utee dans les luxations congenitales, arthrodeses et verrouillage de la hanche dans les pseudarthroses de la coxalgie ou des arthrites deformantes. Presse med, 1928. 36: 695.— Campbell, W. C. Surgery of the hip joint from the physiologic aspect. Surgery, 1940. 7: 107-80. Also J. Indiana M. Ass, 1940, 33: 179-84.—Delchef. J. Chirurgie de la hanche; reflexions k propos de quelques cas. Ann. Inst. chir. Bruxelles, 1934, 35: 46-63.—Dupuy de Frenelle. La voie d'acces ante- rieure sur l'articulation de la hanche. Bull. Soc. chir. Paris, 1928, 20: 551-5.—Fiolle & Luccioni. Une voie d'abord poste- rieure de la hanche. J. chir. Par, 1936, 47: 595-603.— Folliasson, A, & Joly, M. Voies d'abord de 1'articulation de la hanche. Gaz. hop, 1931, 104: 1473-83.—Gamboa, M. La via de acceso anterointerna a la articulacion de la cadera. Bol. Soc. cir. B. Aires, 1933, 17: 81-6.—Marottoli, O. R. Concepto actual de la patologia quiiiirgica de la cadera en la infancia. Prensa med. argent, 1931-32, 18: 999-1007. ------ Con- tribuci6n al estudio de la patologia quiriirgica de la cadera. Rev. cir. B. Aires, 1933, 12: 102; passim.—Massart, R. Voie d'abord sur la hanche pour operer aisement en flexion-abduction du membre. Bull. Soc. chir. Paris, 1933, 25: 301-4.—Mathieu, P. Voie d'acces anterieure sur l'articulation de la haiiche. Bull. Soc. nat. chir. Par, 1926, 52: 640-3.— Osborne, R. P. The approach to the hip-joint; a critical review and a suggested new route. Brit. J. Surg, 1930, 18: 49-52.—Baton, R. Y. A consideration of methods of exposing the hip joint. S. Mary's Hosp. Gaz, Lond, 1930, 36: 95.—Richard, A. Notions actu- elles indispensables sur la chirurgie de la hanche chez l'enfant. Bull. Soc. med. Paris, 1939, 370-6.—Telleen, C. L. A study of an antero-lateral approach to the hip joint of the dog. North Am. Vet, 1937, 18: No. 11, 57-9. Surgery: Arthrodesis. Soe also Hip, Coxalgia. Abageriu, O. Die paraartikuliirc Arthrodese Methode Trosc. Wien. med. Wsehr, 1940, 90: 928-31.—Abbott, L. C, & Fischer. F. J. Arthrodesis of hip, with special reference to a method of securing ankylosis in massive destruction of the joint. Surg Gyn. Obst, 1931, 52: 863-71.—Allende, C. I. Artrodesis extraarticular de la cadera por enclavijamiento iliofemoral con perone. Rev. cir. B. Aires, 1932, 11: 361.—Briggs, H. A combination arthrodesis and sub-trochanteric osteotomy of the hip with a new technic of arthrodesis. J. M. Soc. N Jersey 1937, 34: 490-3.—Brittain, H. A. Ischiofemoral arthrodesis, Brit. J. Surg, 1941-42, 29: 93-104. —Chaklin, V. D. [Intra- extraarticular method of arthrodesis of the hip jointi Ortoo travmat, 1931, 5: 30 8. Also Zsclir. orthop. Chir, 1931, 55: 140-3.—Dclitala, F, te De Marchi, E. Tecnica dell'artrodesi mista deH'aiica. (oor. venet. sc. med, 1939, 13: 373-80.— Dellapiane, R. J, Weber, L. A. |et al.] Artrodesis extraart icular de la cadera. Congr. argent, cir, 1930, 582-94.—Fernandez, L. L. Artrodesis extraarticular de la cadera; tecnica de C'hutro. Prensa med. argent, 1939, 26: pt 2, 2015-22.—Freund, E. Some considerations on subtrochanteric osteotomy and intra- articular arthrodesis of the hip joint. J. Bone Surg, 1936, 18: 654-8.—I.anz, O. Arthrodesis coxae. Ned. tschr. geneesk, 1920, 1: 933.—Massart, R. I. arthrodese de la hanche. Paris chir, 1929, 21: 97-112. ------ Technique des forages, des enchevillemeiits et de l'arthrodese de la hanche ,par la voie t'-aii-cervieule. Bull. Soc. ehir. Pans, 1930, 28: 216-30.— Mathieu. P. L'arthrodese de la hanche; technique ct resultats dun procedi' extra-articulaire. Bull. Soc. nat. chir. Par, 1927, 53: 1241-6. ------ ' L'arthrodese extra-articulaire de la hanche. Presse med, 1930, 38: 165-7.—Mutel & Rousseaux. La valeur du greffon iliaque dans les arthrodeses de la hanche Rev. med. est, 1932, 60: 720-3.— Richard, A, & Grafin, P. Resultats eioignes d'arthrodese de ham-he chez l'enfant Mem Acad, chir". Par, 1936, 62: 677-88.—Rodriguez Egana, A. Tecnica de la artrodesis extra-articular de la cadera con injerto costal. Bol. Soc. cir. B. Aires, 1932, 16: 235-45. Artrodesis extra-articular de cadera con injerto costal. Ibid 1939, 23: 1174.— Wideroe, S. [Periarticular arthrodesis of hip- joint m non-tubereuloi.13 diseases] Norsk mag. laegevid, 1927 ---- Surgery: Arthroplasty. Barthes, M. L. L. E. *Xote sur l'arthro- plastie de l'articulation de la hanche avec trans- position du grand trochanter. 49n. 8? Par 1935. Riedener, F. *Ueber pltislischen Krsatz des Oberschenkelkopf es durch freie Uelier- pflanzung des oberen Drittels des Wadcnbeina [Zurich] 33p. 8? Berl., 1931. Also Beitr. klin. Chir, 1931, 153: Albee, F. H. Arthroplasty of hip following arthrodesis by bone-graft. Internat. Clin, 1928, 38. ser, 2: 220-2, pl. -----. The use of the femoral head as a graft in the Albee reconstruc- tion operation. Internat. J. M. & S, 1934, 47: 389 93. Also Radiol. Rev, 1936, 58: 222-9.------Arthroplasty of the hip and the preservation of its stability. Ann,. Surg, 1935 102: 108-14. ------ & Preston. R. L. A new vitallium cup for arthroplasty of the hip. J. Internat Coll. Surgeons. 1941 4: 289-94— Bade, P. Zur Arthropl astik des Huftgelenks Zschr. orthop. Chir, 1933, 59: 234 -ill. ISacr, W. S. Arthro- plasty of the hip. J. Bone Surg.. 1926, 8: 709-802. Itaker, D. R. A new type of plastic hip cup for arlhroplaM v or for use as an artificial femoral head. Culhrie Olin. Bull, 1941-42, 11: 133.—Baker, L. 1), te Waters, ('. II, jr. Vitallium cup arthro- plasty of the hi]). Arch. Surg, 1942, 44: 531-42.—Bargellini, D. Plastica libera con ribaltamcnto del tetto cotiloideo. Arch. ortop, Milano, 1939, 55: 3-14.—Brackett, E. G. Choice of procedure in reconstruction operations of the hip. Am. ,1 Surg, 1927, n. ser, 2: 216-24. Also Bull. N. York Acad. M, 1927, 3: 357-60. -Camera, U. Trenta casi di ricostruzione operatoria del tetto cotiloideo; indieazioni, tecnica, risultati Arch, ortop, Milano, 1933, 49: 473 500. Campbell, W. C. Arthroplasty of the hip; an analysis of 48 cases. Tr. South Surg. Ass. (1925) 1926, 38: 285-95, 5 pl. Also Surg. Gyn! Obst, 1926, 43: 9-17. ------ Reconstruction operations of the hip joint. Texas J. M, 1925-26, 21: 55.5-8.----- End results of arthroplasty of the hip joint. J. Bone Sur" , 1927, 9: 331-45. Also J. Michigan M. Soc, 1934, 33: 49-58.— Campell. Arthroplastie de la hanche. Marseille med, 1933, 70: 493.— Charry, R. La position basse du volet dans la butee osteoplastique de la hanche. Bull. Soc. chir. Paris, 1939, 31: 348-55.—Colonna, P. C. The Whitman reconstruction opera- tion. Ann. Surg, 1926, 84: 897-901.—Dega, W. Contributo alio studio clinico della ricostruzione del tetto cotiloideo Arch, ortop, Milano, 1934, 50: 261-5.—De Gactano. L. ('ontributo alia tecnica dell'artroplastica deU'anca. Ann. ital. ehir, 1931, 10: 637-45.—Dclitala. F. La mia esperienza di chirurgia riparatrice deU'anca (84 casi) Rapp. Congr. Soc. internat. ehir, 1929-30, 8. Congr, 2: 346-8.—Dupuy de Frenelle. Arthroplastie de la hanche. Techn. chir. Par 1934, 26: 247-76.—Dyas, F. G. Reconstruction of the hip. Illinois M. J, 1935, 68: 124-7.— Egidi, G. Sulla fissazione operatoria extraarticolare dell'anca. Bull. Accad. med. Roma, 1927, 53: 3.6-8.—Finikov, A. Contribution au d6bat sur la chirurgie reparatrice de la hanche. Rapp. Congr. Soc. internat. chir, 1929-30, 8. Congr, 2: 358-60.—Freiberg, J. A. Recent experiences with arthroplasty of the hip with the use of vital- lium caps. Proc. Inst. M. Chicago, 1940-41, 13: 15.—Fuiks, D. M. Arthroplasty of the hip: a statistical study of 60 opera- tions. Arch. Surg, 1938, 36: 387-93.—Gill, A. B. Plastic surgery of the hip. Radiology, 1933, 20: 120-8.—Groves, K. W. H. Some contributions to the reconstructive surgery >f the hip. Lancet, Lond, 1926, 2: 1055-7. Also Brit. J. Surg, 1926-27, 14: 486-517.—Hallock, H. A study and end- result report of 70 arthroplasties and reconstruction operations on the hip joint. Surg. Gyn. Obst, 1939, 68: 106-12.— Hamant, Chalnot & Thomas. Les butees osteoplastiques de la hanche. Rev. med. est, 1934, 62: 418-20.—Harmon, P. H. Arthroplasty of the hip with lucite cups. Proc. Inst. M. Chicago, 1940-41, 13: 413. Also Guthrie Clin. Bull, 1941-42, 11:91-6. ------ Results during the first year following hip arthroplasty with non-metallic foreign body cups of meth- acrylate plastic; pathogenesis and operative technique. Ibid, 124-30.—Hey, E. W. The reconstructive surgery of the hip. Brit. M J, 1926, 2: 871.—Hopkins, H. H. Arthroplasty of hip, with use of vitallium cup. Med. Bull. Veterans Admin, 1938-39, 15: 1. ------ & Zuck, F. N. Arthroplasty of the hip with use of vitallium cup; supplemental report. Ibid, 2l7-—Hybbinette, S. Resultats op6ratoires de la chirurgie reparatrice de l'articulation de la hanche. Rapp. Congr. Soc. internat. chir, 1929-30, 8. Congr, 1: 979-1028, 10 pl — IanSs, A. [Arthroplasty of the hip-jointl Spitalul, 1932, 52: 300.—Inclan. A. The stability of the hip following Whitman's reconstruction operation. J. Bone Surg, 1933, 15: 215-8 — Kleinberg, S. Rcconstruction-arthroplasty operation for the hip Am. J. Surg.. 1932, 18: 64-9. Also repr.—Lasserre, C. Les but6es osteoplastiques de la hanche; techniques; resultats; indications. Bordeaux chir, 1930, 1: 42-8. Also J. med. Pans 1930, 1: 641.—LeCocq, J. F. Shelving operations of the hip. Northwest M, 1938, 37: 107.—Lowendorf, C. S. Whit- man reconstruction operation on the hip joint; an analysis of late results. Arch. Surg, 1932, 25: 863-9. Also repr- Massart, R. A propos des interventions osteoplastiques sur la hanche. Bull. Soc. chir. Paris, 1928. 20: 594-7. Mathieu, P. Chirurgie r6paratrice de la hanche. Rapp. Congr. Soc. internat. Si,929"30' 8' Con8r-. 1:-1029 83. Also Bruxelles med, 1929-30, 10: 975; 1004.—Nowotny, H. Der Rohrenmeissel, ein neues Instrument zur subkutanen Ausfuhrung der Pfan- nendachplastik. Zschr. orthop. Chir, 1933, 59: 125-8 — Padovani, P. Pince porte-greffons pour butees osteoplastiques de la hanche. Presse med, 1936, 44: 130 1.- Parcelier, A., & Chenut, A. Le reperage precis du centre de U tete femorale HIP-JOINT 701 HIP-JOINT dans la chirurgie du col du femur. Bordeaux chir, 1935, 6: 33 —Putti, V. Chirurgia riparatrice dell'articolazione dell'anca. Rapp. Congr. Soc. internat. chir, 1929-30, 8. Congr, 1: 1085- 122, 5 pl.—Robbiani, A. Operaci6n reconstruetiva de la cadera; reconstruction-hip operation de Royal Whitman. Bol. Inst. chn. quir, B. Air, 1938, 14: 1439-725.—Ryerson, E. W. An improved shelf operation at the hip. J. Bone Surg, 1941, 23: 782-7.—Smith-Petersen, M. N. Treatment of malum coxae senilis, old slipped upper femoral epiphysis, intrapelvic pro- trusion of the acetabulum, and coxa plana by means of aceta- buloplasty. Ibid, 1936, 18: 869-80. ------ Arthroplasty of the hip, a new method. Ibid, 1939, 21: 269-88.—Sorrel, E, & Delahaye, A. Chirurgie reparatrice de la hanche; etude critique de 102 interventions. Arch. fr. belg. chir, 1929-30, 32: 197-214, 4 pl. Also Rapp. Congr. Soc. internat. chir, 1929-30, 8. Congr, 2: 331-4.—Speed, J. S. Reconstruction operation on the hip. J. Am. M. Ass, 1926, 87: 1631-5. Also repr.—Speed, K. Hip arthroplasty, with vitallium cap. Tr. West. Surg. Ass. (1939) 1940, 49: 203-73. Also West. J. Surg, 1940, 48: 101-5. Also repr.—Spitzy, H. Pfannendach- plastik bei defekten Huftgelenken. Wien. klin. Wschr, 1934, 47: 655.—Stubenrauch, von. Ueber bemerkenswerte Befunde nach autoplastischem Ersatz des Huftgelenkes mit anschlies- sender schwerer Infektion, nebst kurzen Bemerkungen zur Frage der primaren Wundinfektion durch Aktinomyces. Deut. Zsehr. Chir, 1927, 202: 217-30.—Tavernier & Trillat, A. Des raideurs articulaires apres les butees osteoplastiques de hanche (arthropathies post-operatoires) Presse med, 1937, 45: 1051.—Ternovaia-Sobolevskaia, A. F, & Bochkarev, N. P. [Arthroplastie mobilization of the coxo-femoral joint] Khi- rurgia, Moskva, 1937, No. 3, 107-13, pl.—van Assen, J. [Total acetabulum plastic] Ned. tschr. geneesk, 1935, 79: 5781-5, 2 pl.—Vilardell, J. M. Una indicacion especial de butee osteoplastica de la cadera. Rev. cir. Barcelona, 1935, 9: 477-82.—Whitman, A. Remarks prefatory to a cinemato- graphic presentation of late results of the reconstruction opera- tion. J. Bone Surg, 1926, 8: 803-20.—Wilson, P. D. Arthro- plasty of the hip joint. Ibid, 1942, 24: 474.—Zaremba, G. Sulle artroplastiche dell'anca. Chir. org. movim, 1930-31, 15: 454-64. ---- Surgery: Disarticulation. Amor, J. L. Comentarios acerca de la desarticulaei6n eoxofemoral. Hosp. gen, Mex, 1926, 1: 563-9.—Astley Cooper's first amputation at the hip joint. Med. J. Australia, 1939, 2: 580.—Babcock, W. W. Interilio-abdominal amputa- tion; a description of a new method; with a report of 3 eases. Surg. Gyn. Obst, 1918, 26: 554-9.—Brooks, B. Exarticulation of the hip joint, with preliminary ligation of the common iliac artery. J. Am. M. Ass, 1921, 76: 94-6. Also J. Missouri M. Ass, 1921, 18: 106.—Chaput, H. Trois cas de desarticulation haute de la hanche; procedes sous-trochanterien, sus-tro- chanterien et sus-cotyloidien. Bull. Soc. chir. Pari?, 1916, n. ser, 42: 2897-900.—Chulro, P. A propos de la desarticula tion interilio-abdominale. Ibid, 1918, 44: 1110.—Das Gupta, S. C. Notes on excision of the hip joint. Ind. M. Rec, 1933, 53: 7.—Douriez, H. Desarticulation de la hanche en 3 temps. Paris chir, 1921, 13: 447-9.—Fitzgerald, R. R. Amputation for sarcoma of the neck of the femur bv the interinnomino- abdominal method. J. Bone Surg, 1936, 18: 402-7.—Fitz- williams, D. C. L. Hindquarter amputation for sarcoma. Proc. R. Soc. M, Lond, 1937-38, 31: 548-50.—Garber, N. I. [Case of interilio-abdominal amputation] Sovet. khir, 1931, 1: 505.—Ghitzesco, C. I. La desarticulation de la hanche sous l'hemostase provisoire de l'artere iliaque primitive ou de I'hypogastrique correspondante. Presse med, 1935, 43: 243-5.—Guyot, J. Desarticulation de la hanche. P. verb. Congr. fr. chir, 44: 1154-8.—Huard, P., & Montagne, M. Un procede anti-choc de desarticulation de la hanche. Rev. chir. Par, 1931, 69: 558-81, 8 pl.—Iacobovici, I. Dezarticu- latie inter-ilio-abdominala. Cluj. med, 1920, 1: 335-47.— Judin, S. S. Ilio-abdominal amputation in case of sarcoma; recovery; pregnancy and birth of living child. Surg. Gyn. Obst, 1926, 43: 668-76.—Kadyan, A. A. [Amputation of entire lower extremity with its innominate bone] Laitop. russ. khir, 1900, 5: 657-67.—Leriche, R. A propos de 13 cas de desarticulation de la hanche. Mem. Acad, chir. Par, 1937, 63: 1435-8.—Loeffler, F. Ueber Exarticulatio interileo- abdominalis. Munch, med. Wschr, 1919, 66: 824. Also Zschr. orthop. Chir, 1919-20, 39: 305; 1922-23, 43: 444.— Morris, R. T. Hip joint amputation. West. M. Times, 1917, 37:1.—Pascalis, G. Amputation interilio-abdominale. Progr. med. Par, 1936, 1481-5.—Perret. C. De l'importance capitale qu'il y a, en presence d'une tumeur maligne gigantesque de la cuisse, d'op6rer en position de Trendelenburg pour lier l'artere iliaque primitive par voie abdominale, puis sectioniier entre ligatures les vaisseaux femoraux avant de proc6der k la desar- ticulation de la hanche. Presse med, 1926, 34: 389-91.— Phocas. Desarticulation de la hanche droite par le procede de la raquette externe, et par desarticulation premiere. Bull. Soc. chir. Paris, 1917, n. ser, 43: 2256.—Rabinovich, J. M. [Exarticulatio interileoabdominalis; amputatio interpuboiliaca] Nov. khir, Moskva, 1925, 1: No. 3, 374-7.—Ripert, M. La desarticulation de hanche et son appareillage. Rev. orthop. Par, 1921, 3. ser, 8: 319-22.—Riswasch, S. I. Amputatio interilioabdominalis. Deut. Zsehr. Chir, 1932-33, 238: 121-7.—Rivera y Sans, J. Procedimiento para la desarticula- tion coxo-femoral. Congr. hisp. portug. cir, 1898, 1. Congr, \?17 T- Ch?&4 ,7-xt [Exarticulatio interileo-abdominalis Vest, khir, 1927 10: No. 30, 61-6.-Schaldemose, V. A case of exarticulatio (amputatio) interilio-abdominalis. Acta chir scand 1925, 58: 523-32.-Stajano, C, Bennati, D, & Pertuzzo «. JU factor determinante del schoc en las desarticulaciones de la. cadera. An. Fac. med, Montev, 1928, 13: 642-52 Also Rev. sudamer. med. Par, 1930, 1: 175-80.—Strauss, K lixarticulatio coxae bei Schwangerschaft und allgemeiner Sepsis. Munch, med. Wschr, 1939, 86: 1751-3.—Stubenrauch L. von. Autoplastische Knochenverpflanzung in den Weich- teilstumpf bei Exarticulatio coxae. Zbl. Chir, 1922 49- 'il8TJ>7'leS£l '?nS ago; amputation at the hip joint, January 16- 1i8.24; Guys Hosp. Gaz, 1925, 39: 83.—Tedenat. La desarticulation de la cuisse (procede Furneaux-Jordan) Mont- pellier med, 1917, 39: 476-85.—Tixier & Arnulf. Auto- transfusion au cours d'un desarticulation de la hanche, en utihsant le sang du membre enleve. Lyon chir, 1935,'32: 443-5.—Torraca, L. Aneurisma artero-venoso in un moneone di amputazione della coscia. Riv. osp, 1^1 ■■■, 8: 268-70.— Torrance, G. Amputation of the hip-joint with removal of the whole bone, and flaps amputated just above the knee. Surg Gyn Obst, 1920, 30: 308.—Wyeth, J. A. Bloodless amputation at the hip joint. J. Am. M. Ass, 1921, 76: 28.—1 vert, A. Note sur un ras de desarticulatio inter-ili -abdominale. Bull Soc. chir. Paris, 1918, 44: 1070-84. ------ Nouveau cas de desarticulation inter-iieo- ou il6o-abdominale pour osteo- sarcome du bassin. Rev. chir. Par, 1918, 56: 93-122.— Zarraga, F. Procedimiento para la desarticulaci6n coxo- femoral. Mem. Congr. med. nac. mex, 1910, 4. Consr 268-70. e " ---- Surgery: Methods. Veltmann, A. *Beitrag zur Gabelung des oberen Femurendes nach Bayer-Lorenz (mit Beschreibung eines autoptischen Befundes) 16p. 8? Miinster-W., 1933. Albee, F. H. The lever at the top of the femur and its surgical elongation. J. Am. M. As?, 1939, 112: 2037-9.— Allison, N. Arthrotomy of the hip. Surg. Gyn. Obst, 1928 47: 375-&3— Backer-Grfmdahl, N. [Smith-Petersen's hip- socket] Nord. med, 1940. 7: 1629.—Bakushinsky, R. N. [Modification in the supra-eondylian osteotomy of the hip] Ortop. travmat, 1934, 8: 36-9, 8 pl—Berntsen, A. [Technique in inforatiO colli et capitis femoris (forage of Graber-Duvernay)] Ugeskr. laeger, 1936, 98: 622-6. Also Acta chir. scand, 1937- 38, 80: 82-92. ------ [The proper inforation screw] Ugeskr. laeger, 1939, 101: 1295.—Boisan, E. J. A new treatment of intracapsular fractures of the neck of the femur and Calve- Legg-Perthes' disease. J Bone Surg, 1932, 14: 884; 1934, 16: 75.—Camitz, H. On the bifurcation operation by the von Baever-Lorenz procedure, and the low osteotomy of Sehanz. Acta orthop. scand, 1934, 5: 261-357.—Campbell, W. C. Stabilization of the hip joint. Am. J. Surg, 1939, 44: 242-51.— Cervera y Ruiz, E. Decolaci6n coxo-femoral. Congr. hisp. portug. cir, 1898, 1. Congr, 395.—Chandler, F. A. Hip- fusion operation. J. Bone Surg, 1933, 15: 947-52.—Dardel, G. L'operation d'AIbee, resultats anatomiques et fonetionnels. Schweiz. med. Wschr, 1926, 56: 439-41.—Dubois, M. Indika- tionen zur Stellungskorrektur durch Osteotomie am oberen Femurende. Ibid, 1938, 68: 489-91— Galland, M. Butee osteoplastique de la hanche, k contrefort iliaque. Bull. Soc. chir. Paris, 1935, 27: 118-24.—Galland, W. I. 'Ihe bifurcation operation; indications, technique, and results. Surg. Gyn. Obst, 1930, 50: 90-100.—Gebhardt, K. M uskelmechanische Probleme bei Hiiftgelenksgabelung, Pfannendachplastik und anderen Eingriffen an den unteren Gliedmassen. Deut. med. Wschr, 1939, 65: 1527.—Ghormley, R. K. Use of the anterior superior spine and crest of ilium in surgery of the hip joint. J. Bone Surg, 1931, 13: 784-98.—Girard, P. M. Hip-joint fusion and the shelf operation. Ibid, 1935, 17: 443-9. Also repr.—Girdlestone, G. R. The role of fusion operations as applied to the hip-joint. Brit. M. J, 1933, 1: 777.—Haberler, G. Die Inversion nach Lorenz; ihre Anwendungsgebiete und spateren Resultate. Arch, orthop. UnfaUchir, 1931, 30: 270-88.—Henderson, M. S. Role of fusion operations as applied to the hip-joint. Brit. M. J, 1933, 1: 327-30 — Hustin, A, & Leemans. Forage du col du femur; guide simplifie. Bull. Soc. nat. chir. Par, 1933, 59: 740-4.—King, T. The value of femoral osteotomy for diseases and injuries of the hip joint. Med. J. Australia, 1940, 1: 253-68, 3 pl.— Kini, M. G. Role of oblique osteotomy of upper end of femur in hip joint surgery. Ind M. Gaz, 1940, 75: 257-61.— Kusslik, M. I. [Review of R. R. Vreden's operative methods] Ortop. travmat, 1934, 8: 11-8.—Lorenz, A. Ueber Fehler- quellen und Rezidive bei parartikuliirer Osteotomie an Huft- gelenken. Zschr. Orthop, 1935-36, 64: 153-60.—Lowendorf, C. S. The bifurcation operation; a study of late results. J. Bone Surg, 1933, 15: 403-73.—Massart, R. Les operations osteoplastiques sur la hanche; indications et resultats eioignes (arthrodeses, butees, osteotomies, resections, operations reconstructives, pratiquees depuis 1926) Bull. Soc. chir. Paris, 1932, 24: 301-37. ------ Les osteotomies de l'extre- mite superieure du femur dans le traitement des arthrites douloureuses de la hanche et des luxations inveterees en particulier. Ibid, 1936, 28: 25-36.—Milch, H. The bifurca- tion operation. Surgery, 1940, 8: 686-98. ------ The pelvic support osteotomy. J. Bone Surg, 1941, 23: 581-95.— HIP-JOINT 702 HIPPKE Niedererker. Revision der Huftosteotomien auf Grund neuer mechanischer Ansichten, Berechnungen und eines eigenartig konstruierten Modelles. Verh. Deut. orthop. Ges. (1935) 1936, 30. Kongr, 138-42.—Papin. E. Technique de la butee de la hanche chez l'enfant a 1'anesthesie locale. Bordeaux chir, 1936. 7: 432.—Pitzen, P. Beckenfixation bei der Hiiftge- lenksmobilisation. Zschr. orthop. Chir, 1934, 61: 504-8 — Platou. E. Subtrochanteric osteotomy in relatively old con- genital luxation of the hip, arthritis deformans and coxa vara. Acta orthop. scand, 1938, 9: 132-51.—Platteel, J. A. C. IPauwels's operation in coxa vara and pseudarthrosis] Ned. tschr. geneesk, 1936, 80: 4965-70.—Rodriguez Egafia. Mi experiencia sobre la operaei6n de Robertson-Lavalle. Sem. med, B. Air, 1927, 34: pt 2, 592-004.—Roederer, C. A piopos de la technique du forage de la hanche. Bull. Soc. chir. Pan-, 1936, 28: 239. Also J. med. Paris, 1936, 56: 654 — Seddon. H. J. The angle of abduction of the hip after sub- trochanteric osteotomy. Lancet, Lond, 1938, 2: 552-4.— Shanin, A. P. [Method of operative mobilization of the hip- joint] J. teor. prakt. med, 1920, 1: 457-68.—Smirnova, A. M. [Operative approach to the eoxofemoral joint for extirpation of periarticular foci] Vest, khir, 1940, 60: 419-30.—Sorrel, E, Guichard, & Longuet. De' la reduction des luxations congeni- tales de la hanche et du traitement des epiphysiolyses de la coxa-vara par la traction au fil de Kirchner. Mlm. Acad. chir. Par, 1936, 62: 1280-91.—Speed, K. Hip joint fusion. Tr. West. Surf. Ass, 1936, 46: 325-37. Also Surgery, 1937, 1: 740-7.—Zahradnicek. L'importance de la detorsion du col du femur dans la chirurgie de la hanche. Mem. Acad, chir. Par, 1937, 63: 645-50. ---- Surgery: Resection. Assen, J. van [Excision of head of femur] Ned. tschr. geneesk, 1930, 74: 1395-7, pl.—Mathieu, P. La resection arthroplastique de la hanche. J. chir. Par, 1931, 38: 1-23.— Patel. Resections de la hanche faites par Oilier. Lyon chir, 1930, 27: 824-31.—Perera. Restauracion funcional, en un caso de resecei6n eoxofemoral. Progr. clin., Madr, 1918, 11: 151.—Sarasola, R. D, & Perpina, V. S. Neues Verfahren zur Resektion der Hufte. Zbl. Chir., 1920, 53: 2329-32.—Ver- bruggo, J. Resultats eioignes de la resection de la hanche. P. verb. Congr. fr. chir, 1938, 47: 890-8. ---- Synovia, and synovial membrane. Anserov, N. I. [Interarticular ligament of the pelvis and femur in man] J. teor. prakt. med, 1929, 3: 249-74. Also Zschr. ges. Anat, 1. Abt, 1929, 89: 580-605.—Finder, J. G. Transitory synovitis of the hip joint in childhood. J. Am. M. Ass, 1936, 107: 3-5.— Finorhietto. R, & Fernandez, L. L. Cadera; tecnica para la biopsia de la sinovial. Prensa med. argent, 1940, 27: pt 2, 1847-9.—Fransen, J. W. P. [Lubrication of the hip-joint] Ned. tschr. geneesk, 1928, 72: pt 2, 5876.— Kleinberg, S. Acute synovitis of the hip in young children Arch. Pediat, N. Y, 1926, 43: 215-24.—Ranch, S. Transitory synovitis of the hip joint in children. Am. J. Dis. Child, 1940, 59: 1245-65. ---- Tumor. .See also Hip, Tumor. Bastos, M, & Gonzalez-Aguilar, J. Artrofitosis multiple de la cadera. Arch, med, Madr, 1928, 28: 77-87.—Emmert, M. Tumor of hip joint. Nebraska M. J, 1933, 18: 435.— Etienne-Martin, M, & Colson, P. Tumeur conjonctive de la cuisse avec atteinte de l'articulation do la hanche. Ann anat. path. Par, 1936, 13: 534-9.—Klages, F. Synoviales Sarkoendotheliom des Huftgelenkes. Arch. klin. Chir, 1939, 197: 137-46.—Lam pins, S. Ueber das primare Gelenksarkorri mit besonderer Berucksichtigung der Hiiftgelenklokalisation. Ibid, 1938-39, 194: 634-42. HIPPE, Bernhard, 1900- *Falle von Fremdkorpern im Ohr, in den Luft- und Speise- wegen [Frankfurt] 41p. 8? Diiren [n. pub.] 1935. v HIPPEL, Arthur von, 1841-1916. For portrait, photograph, see Collection in library. HIPPEL, Eugen von, 1867- Die Krank- heiten der Sehnerven. 222p. illust. 8° Berl J. Springer. 1921, Forms Handb. ges. Augenheilkunde (Graefe-Saemisch) 2 Aufl, 10. Rap, B2. T, Bd 7. For biography see Klin. Mbl. Augenh, 1939, 103: 632-4 portr. (Baurmann) HIPPELI, Hans, 1910- *Ueber Nasen- plastiken. 27p. 8? Wurzb., R. Mayr, 1934. HIPPEL'S DISEASE. See Angiomatosis; also Retina, Angiomatosis HIPPKE, Erich, 1888- , DOWALZIG, Hans [et al.] Transportation of wounded by airplane in the Polish-German war [Transl. of 4 articles in the Der Deutsche Milittirarzt, 1940, v.5] Ed. by Colonel Harold W. Jones, v v 27cm. [Wash., 1940] Typewritten. HIPPLER, Margot, 1905- *Das S< hick- sal unserer Psoriasispatienten nach klinischer und ambulanter Behandlung. Np. 8? Miinst C. J. Fahle, 1932. HIPPMANN, Heinrich [Hubert] 1900- *Ueber Lungenbefunde bei Tuberkulose des Skelettsystems und ihre gegenseitigen Beziehun- gen. 26p. 10 tab. 8? Bonn, P. Kubens, 1932. HIPPOBOSCIDAE. See also Alkaloids, Determination; Diptera. Bau, A. Das Genus Ornithoica rondani (Diptera, Hippo- boscidae) Zbl. Bakt, 2. Abt, 1929, 79: 216 8. -Bedford, G. A. H. Description of a new species of Hippobosca (Diptera pupipara) Onderstepoort J. Vet. Sc, 1936, 7: 67, fig.— Bcquaert, J. Notes on Hippoboscidae; the subfamily Hippo- boscinae. Psyche, Bost, 1930, 37: 303-26.—Coatney, G. R. On the biology of the pigeon fly (Diptera, Hippoboscidae) Parasitology, Lond, 1931, 23: 525-32.—Ferris, G. F. Ob- servations on the larvae of some Diptera pupipara, with de- scription of a new species of Hippoboscidae. Ibid, 1923-24, 15: 54-8.—Jobling, B. A comparative study of the structure of the head and mouth parts in the Hippoboscidae (Diptcr-i pupipara) Ibid, 1926, 18: 319-49, 5 pl.—Prouty, M. J, & Coatney, G. R. Further studies on the biology of I lie pigeon fly, Pseudolynchia maura Bigot (Diptera; Hippoboscidae) Ibid, 1934, 26: 249-58.— Robeits, J. I. On the bionomics of Hippobosca equina. Ann. Trop. M. Parasit, Liverp, 1925-26, 19: 81-90. ------ The anatomy and morphology of Hippo- bosca equina. Ibid, 1927-28, 21: 11-24, 3 pl.—Schurmans Stekhoven, J. H, jr. Studies on Hippobosca maculata Leach and H. equina L. in the Dutch East Indian Archipelago Parasitology, Lond, 1926, 18: 35-50, 2 pl, ch.—Warburton, C. Ornithomyia avicularia (Diptera, Hippoboscidae) as the carrier of Mallophaga, with some remarks on phoresy in insects. Ibid, 1928, 20: 175-8. HIPPOCAMPUS. See under Brain. HIPPOCAMPUS [Syngnathidae] Ginsburg, I. Review of the seahorses (Hippo- campus) found on the coasts of the American continents and of. Europe. p.497-594. 8? Washington, D. C, 1937. Blanchard. Note sur une vari^te d'hippocampe. Bull. Sta. biol% Arcachon, 1922, 19: 55-9.—Roule, L, & Verrier, M. L. Structure histologique de la bourse marsupiale des hippocampes males. C. rend. Soc. biol, 1930, 104: 743-5. HIPPOGLOSSIDAE. See Halibut. HIPPOKRATES, 460-390 B. C. [Works] The genuine works of Hippocrates; transl. from the Greek by Francis Adams, viii p.; 384p. illust. 26cm. Bait., Williams & Wilkins co., 1939. ---- ['A from the genuine works of Hippocrates, transl- from the Greek by Francis Adams, London, 1849- lp. 4? Chic, Northwest. Univ. M. School, 1938. ----- [LTfpi iepuv, iSarwv, tottoov] TJepl akpuiv und die Sammlung der Hippokratischen Schrif- ten; von L. Edelstein. 218p. 8? Berl., 1931. ---- The same. Wanderarzt und Aitologe; Studien zur hippokratischen Schrift IIEPI AEPftN TAATflN TOH12N; von H. Diller. 120p. 8? Lpz., 1934. ---- [LTepi diairrjs b^kwv voa-qp.a.T03v\ On regi- men in acute diseases, p.60-99. 8? Bait., 1938-39. In Med. Classics, 1938-39, 3: ----- Ilepi 701*775 [Also Hepl 0p. Arch. Gesch. Med, 1911, 5: 129-60. Also repr.—Gils. J. B. 1-'. van [Hippocrates on a visit to Democ- ritus] Ned. tschr. geneesk, 1926, 70: 542; 1936, 80: 3171 — Giordano. D. Ancora a proposito di: Un commentatore del Libro delle ulcere di Ippocrate ed una diseendenza di chirurghi: I. Cignozzi. Kiv. stor. sc. med, 1925, 16: 63.—Giuliani, G. La chirurgia di Ippocrate. Minerva med. Tor, 1931, 22: 933-7.—Greenwood, M. Hippocrates and Galen. In his Epidemics [dec] Lond.. 1935, 15-30.—Gualino, L. II consulto d'Ippocrate. In his Suggi med. stor. Tor, 1930, 59-88.— Haberling, W. Die Grundgedanken des Hippokrates. Zschr. arztl. Fortbild, 1937, 34: 175.—Hippocrates, the Father of scientific medicine. Clin. M. & S, 1940, 47: 169, portr.— Ilberg, J. Hippokrates und Demokrit. Arch. Gesch. Med, 1912-13, 6: 456.—Ippocrate e l'ascoltazionc del petto. Minerva med. Tor, 1940, 31: pt 2, varia, 534-6 (microfilm)—Ippocrate e la tubercolosi. Ibid, 378-80 (microfilm)—Jeanselme, E, & Oeconomos, L. Hippocrate repr^senW sous les traits d'un medecin uroscope. Aesculape, Par, 1926, 16: n. ser, 110.— Koch, R. Warum kamen die hippokratischen Aphorismen zu klassischer Bedeutung? Miinch. med. Wschr, 1933, 80: 189-91. ------• Auslegung des ersten hippokratischen Aphorismus. In Natur & Heilwiss. (Festgabe G. Sticker) Berl, 1930, 1-10. •------Auslegung des dritten hippokrati- schen Aphorismus. Sudhoffs Arch, 1933, 26: 281-8.—Krayl. K. Contraria und Similia in griechischem Stil. Med. Koibl. Wurttemberg, 1932, 102:259-61. ------ Ein philosopbisches Stiick aus dem Corpus Hippocraticum. Ibid, 459-61.— Kukos, A. Hippokrates und die moderne Medizin. Wien. klin. Wsehr, 1940, 53: 657-61.—Kuschev, N. [Hippocrates] Vrach. delo. 1927. 10: 321 -8. — Ligeros, K. A. The precursors of Hippocrates. In his How Ancient Healing [&c] N. Y„ 1937, 373-80. ------ Ilippoeiatos. Ins work, and his accomplish- ments. Ibid, 381-406.— I.orimor, G. An address on me.Heine in ancient Greece: the methods of Hippocrates and work ac- complished by him. Brit. M. J, 1907, 2: 190-9—Lulofs, H. J. [Hippocrates on the art of healing] Ned. tschr. geneesk, 1923, 57: pt2, 49-58. ------ [Concept of nature by Hippocrates] Ibid, 192(1, 70: pt 2, 1535-40.—Lund, F. B. Hippocratic surgerv. Ann. Surg, 1935, 102: 531-47. Also Tr. Am. Surg. Ass, 1935, 53: 50-66.—Major, R. H. Hippocrates and the Island of Cos. Vale J. biol, 1941-42, 14: 1-11.—Metzger, C. La doctrine medicale d'Hippocrate. Arch. med. Angeis, 1937, 41: 133-9.—Micca, A. Tre libri della Collezione ippocratica; su argomento pediatrico. Clin, pediat. Mod, 1931, 13: 74-87.—Montoro, O. Discurso de contestaci6n al Doctor Horacio Abascal. Vida nueva, Habana, 1937, 40: 32-44.— Oath (The i of Hippocrates. Tr. Am. Coll. Proct, 1931, 8: 3, portr.— Oliver, J. R. The philological approach to the Hippoi■iiuean corpus. Bull. Johns Hopkins Hosp, 1930, 46: 142-4.—Orgaz, J. Tu jurainento, padre Hipocrates. Dia mid., B. An.. 1940, 12: 339.—Pazzini, A. II trattato de corde della collezione Ippocratica. Lass. clin. ter, 1936, 35: Suppl, 81-96.—Petrequin, J. E. La chirurgie a-t-il, comme le protend Eloy dans son dictionnaire histonque, iti s6paree de la mede- cine au temps d'Hippocrate? Presse m<5d. beige, 1863-64, 16: 149-51.—Picaza, S. Hip6crates: su doctrina y juicio critico de la misma; su lugar en la historia; valor de la cultura cldsica. Rev. mdd. cubana. 1934, 45: 1286; 1935, 46: 395.—Porter, L. Hippocratic medicine. California West, M, 1930, 32: 181; 249; 350.—Poucel, J. L'oeuvre chirurgicale d'Hippocrate. Marseille m.',l, 1938. 75: pt 2, 113-22.—Power, Sir D'A. The Scamnum Hippocratis. Proc. R. Soc. M, Lond, 1924-25, 18: Sect. Hist. Med, 15-7.—Propper-Grashchenkov, N. I. 'Medical history; Hippocrates; 2,400 years from date of birth] Sovet. m..I, 1941, 5: 47-52.—Reitzer, H. Der 2400. Ge- hurtstag vm!i Hippokrates. Schweiz. med. Wschr, 1940, 70: 821.— Riddel!. W. R. Hippocrates and the seasons. Canad. J. M. ^ S.. l'.rj'.i. 65: 105-10.—Roger, H. La philosophic d'Hippocrate. l'r<—c med, 1933, 41: 451; 722— Schlichting, T. H. Idardina1 thoughts of Hippociates] Xed. tschr. geneesk, 1936,80:4023-30. ------ [Hippocratic treatment of internal diseases] Ibid, 1037, 81: 1452-60.—Scholtz, M. Hippocrates' aphorisms. California West. M, 1940, 52: 125; passim.— Senn, G. Leber Hetkunft und Stil der Beschrcibungen von Experimenton irn Corpus Hippocraticum. Sudhoffs Arch, 1920, 22: 217-89.—Souques, A. Connaissances neurologiques d'Hippocrate. Rev. neur, 1'ar, 1934, 41: 1; 177.—HudliofT, K. Where was Hippocrates (460 B. C.-390 B. C.) the Great horn'.' Ann. M. Hist, 1930, n. ser, 2: 18.------Hippokrates, der Vater der Medizin, auch der Vater der Hvgiene. Fortsch. Med, 1932, 50: 509-13. Suheyl Unver. Hippocrate et sa grande place dans la mytliologie t'.ro-e. Arch, balkan. mid. chir. Par, 1939, 1: 10-4.—I'llman, K. V. The doctor laughs; medical mummeries, collect ed. recollected and edited by E. V. Ullman: The death of Hippocrates, a legend. West. J. Surg, 1936, 44: 702-11.— I'nger, F. C. [Great editors of Hippocrates' works and the hist orv of medicine] Ned. tschr. geneesk, 1927, 71: 2493-505.—Walter. A. La cuesti6n hipo- cnitica. Sem. med, B. Air., 1926, 33: pt 2, 467-75.—Weindler, I'. Das Bildnis des Hippokrates. Hippokrates. Stuttg, 1938 9:410-3.------Zur Bildnisfrage des Hippokrates. Munch med. Wschr, 1938, 85: 83S 11.- Wellmann, M. Die Sehrift Ilepi itpris voaov des Corpus Hippocraticum. Sudhoffs Arch 1929,22:290-312. ------ Das II.\ giomon des Hippokrates! (Quellen Gesch. Naturwiss. Med, 1033, 4: 1-5. For portrait, photograph of bust, see Collection in library. For liogiaphv see Med. Life, 1930. 37: 303-8 (E. B. Pater- son) AUo N. England .1. Med, 1931, 201: 569-71. See also Kaufman, A. A brief sketch of the life and teachings of Hippocrates. Med. Mentor, 1931, 2: 117-21. HIPPOKRATES; Zeitschrift fiir Kinlii-its- bestrebungen dor Gegenwartsmedizin. Stuttg., v.l, 1928/29- Subtitle changes with v.4 to Zschr. prakt. Heilk.; v.7, pt 2 Wsehr. biol. Med. Theor. Prax.; v.8, pt 1, Wschr. deut. Heilk. HIPPOKRATISM. See also Greece, Medicine; Hippokrates. Diller, H. Eine stoiseh-pneumatische Sehrift irn Corpus Hippocraticum. Sudhoffs Arch, 1936, 29: 178-95.—GiufTre, I, La dottrina di Ippocrate. Ann. clin. med. Pal, 1930- 31, 20: 85; 269.—Guiart, J. Hippocrate et!'ecole de Cnide. Marseille mid., 1938, 75: pl 2. 105-12.--Heidel. W. A. The science of the time. In his Hmpocr. .Med, N. V, 1941, 15-25.—Marin, J. El origen de la medieina hipocratiea. An. Soc. med. quir. Guvas, 1938, 18: 035 56. Newton, R. C. The Hippocratic era in medicine. Med. Kee, N. V, 1906, 69: 538-42.— Temkin, O. Geschichte des Hippokratismus im ausgehenden Altertum. Kyklos, Lpz, 1932, 4: 1-80. ---- Neo-hippokratism. See also Medicine, Philosophy. Ai.bes, R. *L'evolution medicale et la pensde Hippocratique [Lyon] 83p. 24J^cm. Bourg, 1937. Cartier, B. *La medecine d'Hippocrate et celle d'aujourd'hui. 61p. 8? Par., 1926. Cottenceatj, L. *Le neo-hipDOcratisme. 74p. 8? Par., 1935. Heidel, W. A. Hippocratic medicine; its spirit and method. 149p. 21cm. N. V., 1941. Aschner, B. Die Bedeutung des Hippokratismus fiir die pratische Medizin. Sitzber. Kongr. Liga homeop. internat, 1935, 10. Congr, 169-82. ------ Praktischer HippokratiMnus. Wien. med. Wschr, 1936, 86: 314; 345; 402. ------ Neo- Hippocratism m everyday practice. Bull. Hist. M, 1941, 10: 260-71.-- Bergcr, H. Die Hippokratitis; meine diesjiihrige Bitte an die Kongresse. Zschr. arztl. Fortbild, 1939, 36: 220-3.—Bross, K. [Why the tendency to return to the Hippo- cratic conceptions of medicine?] Med. prakt, Poznari, 1936, 10: 186-92.—Castiglioni, A. L'orientamento neoippocratico del pensiero medico contemporaneo. Minerva med. Tor, 1932, 23: 621-30.—Cawadias, A. Neo-hippocratic tendencie: of contemporary medicine. Brit. Homeop. J, 1932, 22, 144-08.------Neohippocratism. Proc. R. Soc. M, Lond. 1937-38, 31: 27-38.--De Renzi, S. Intorno alia medicina ippocratica, ed alio spirito di essa conservatosi sempre in Italia. Filiatre sebezio, Nap, 1841, 21: 290- 326.—Disertori, B. Pitagorismo e ippocratismo in medicina e in biologia. Boll. med. trent, 1932, 47: 123-32.—Heidel. W. A. The medical profession. In his Hippocr. Med, N. Y, 1941, 20—39. ----- Scientific methods. Ibid, 57-116.------ Medicine as an art. Ibid, 117-36. ----Some scientists of the day. Ibid, 40-56.—Herscovici, H. La medecine n6o-hippocratique. Rev. med. Par, 1939, 56: 395-425.—Laignel-Lavastine. Le n6o-hippocratisme. Presse mid., 1937, 45: 1215. ------ La doctiine hippocratique et l'induction en mfedecine. Marseille med, 1938, 75: pt 2, 325-31.—Lasserre, J. D'Hippocrate au neo-hippocratisme. An. Fac. med. Porto Alegre, 1938-39, 1: 56-61.—Leibbrand, W. Das Missverstehen der hippokrati- schen Erfahrung. In his Gottl. Stab d. Aeskulap, Salzb, 1939, 29-44.—Martiny. Le piemier Congres national de medecine n6o-Ilippoeratique; Maiseille, 13 novembre 1938. Press- med, 1039, 47: 35 -7.- -Meyer-Steineg, T. Der hippo- , ralischctiedanke. b orbl. allg. arztl. Ycrein. Thiiringen, 1927, 56: 1-3.—Midler, M. Der hippokratische Gedanke in der neuen Medizin. In Naturl. Heilweise (C. Adam) Jena, 1938, 127-37.—Pizarro Crespo, E. El renacimiento del neo-Hippo- cratismo en Europa. Dia med, B. Air, 1938, 10: 1172.— Ramos Baez. P. Los pi inur os pasos en la fisio-patologfa de la medicina dinamica; medicina neo-hipocr&tica o neuro-humoral- tisular. Rev. mid. cubana, 1942, 53: 120-33.—Vires. L'hippo- cratisme medical montpellierain. Bull. Soc. fr. hist, mid, 1936, 30: 273-88.— Zervos, S, Martel [et al.] Discours. Bull. Acad, med. Par, 1937, 3. ser. Par, 118: 389-95. HIPPOLITE, Jean, 1910- *Contribution a l'etude du traitement des plaies par les fer- ments lactiques [Alfort] 84p. 8? Par., Vignot freres, 1933. HIPPOMANE 705 HIPPURIC ACID HIPPOMANE. See also Euphorbiaceae. [Action of the so-called poisonous shade of certain trees] Ny pharm. tid, Kbh, 1871, 3: 331-4. HIPPOPOTAMUS. Parker, G. H. The normal period of submergence for the hippopotamus. Am. J. Physiol, 1932, 99: 577. HIPPULIN. See Estrogen, Equilenin. HIPPURIC ACID [C6H5.CO.NH.CH2.- COOH] See also Amino acids; Diabetes mellitus. DeLor, C. J, & Reinhart, H. L. An analysis of the hippuric acid galactose tolerance, bromsulphthalein and prothrombin tests in 381 cases. Am. J. Clin. Path, 1940, 10: 617-22 — Filippi, E. Su i metodi di determinazione quantitativa dell'acido ippurico e descrizione di un nuovo metodo semplice e precise Arch. farm, sper, 1918, 26: 243-56. ------ Nuovo metodo di determinazione quantitativa dell'acido ippurico. Boll. chim. farm, 1920, 59: 27.—Josephson, B. A. Die Dissozia- tionskonstante der Hippursaure. Biochem. Zschr, 1933, 267: 74-6.—Kraus, I, & Dulkin, S. The determination of hippuric acid in urine. J. Lab. CUn. M, 1940-41, 26: 729-32.—Marron, T. U. Effect of added salts on recoverv of hippuric acid from urine. Ibid, 1941-42. 27: 108-10— Salkowski, E. [Hippu- rated ferric oxide and its application in estimation of hippuric acid] Pharm. tid, Kbh, 1868, 7: 237-9.—Weichselbaum, T. E, & Probstein, J. G. Determination of hippuric acid in urine. J. Lab. CUn. M, 1938-39, 24: 636-9. --- Metabolism. ScHijTT, E. *Stofl\vechselversuche mit Hexa- hydrohippursaure und Hexahydrobenzoyl-Sarko- sin [Zurich] 44p. 8? Solothurn, 1936. Diack, S. L, & Lewis, H. B. Studies in the synthesis of hippuric acid in the animal organism; a comparison of the rate of elimination of hippuric acid after the ingestion of sodium benzoate, benzyl alcohol, and benzyl esters of succinic acid. J. Biol. Chem, 1928, 77: 89-95.—Griffith, W. H. Benz-oylated amino acids in the animal organism; the behavior of hippuric acid following its oral administration. Ibid, 1925, 66: 671-81. ----- & Cappel, P. B. Benzoylated amino acids in the animal organism; the hydrolysis of hippuric acid in the ali- mentary canal of the rabbit. Ibid, 683-90.—Hewitt, E. A. Hippuric acid elimination in the urine of cattle. Cornell Vet, 1929, 19: 318-25.—Smith, F, & Schwei, G. A study of the excretion of hippuric acid in the rabbit. Marquette M. Rev, 1939-40, 4: 66-8.—Snapper, I. [Formation and excretion of hippuric acid in man] Ned. tschr. geneesk, 1921, 65: 3044-50. Also KUn. Wschr, 1924, 3: 55.—Snapper, K. Zur Kenntnis des Hippursaurestoffwechsels beim Menschen. Wien. med. Wschr, 1922, 72: 825.—Takahashi, M. The fate of hippuric acid in the chicken organism. J. Biochem, Tokyo, 1928-29, 10: 457-61.—Violle, P. L. De I'dlimination de l'acide hip- purique k Vitat normal et pathologique. Ann. mid., Par, 1920, 7: 274-9. Also C. rend. Soc. biol, 1920, 83: 94-7. --- Pharmacology. Hoffmanx, W. L. *Die pharmakologischen Wirkungen des Benzylamins und seiner Homo- logen [Frankfurt] 24p. 21cm. Aschaffenburg, 1937. Griffith, W. H. A toxic effect of sodium hippurate. Proc. Am. Soc. Biol. Chem, 1938, 8: No. 7, 46— Griggs, W. B. A proving with pharmacological investigations of hippuric acid. J. Am. Inst. Homeop, 1921-22, 14: 592-7.—Love, G. R. Hippuric acid. Ibid, 1923, 16: 120-3. --- Synthesis. Bignami, G. Ricerche sulla sintesi ippurica neH'organismo umano; sul comportamento dell'acido glrcuronico nelle urine dopo somministrazione di benzoato sodieo. Biochim. ter. sper, 1924, 11: 383-93. Also Boll. Soc. med. chir, Pavia, 1924, 37: 121; 509; 531; 1925, 38: 757; 787.—Borsook, H, & Dubnoff, J. W. The biological synthesis of hippuric acid in vitro. J. Biol. Chem, 1940, 132: 307-24.—Csonka, F. A. Varieties of protein as factors in hippuric acid production. Proc. Soc. Exp. Biol, N. Y, 1923-24, 21: 169.—Griffith, W. H. A note on the in- fluence of the diet on the synthesis of hippuric acid. J. Biol. Chem, 1925, 64: 401-8. ------ Benzoylated amino acids in the animal organism; a method for the determination of hippuric acid and a study of the synthesis of hippuric acid in rabbits. Ibid, 1926, 69: 197-208. ------■ & Lewis, H. B. Studies in the synthesis of hippuric acid in the animal organism; the influence of amino-acids and related substances on the synthesis and rate of elimination of hippuric acid after the 227475—VOL. 7, 4th SERIES-----45 administration of benzoate. Ibid, 1923, 57: 1-24. ------ The influence of the protein of the diet on the synthesis and rate of elimination of hippuric acid after the administration of benzoates. Ibid, 697-707.—Hara, T. Ueber den Einfluss der Eiweissfettdiat auf die Hippursauresynthese. J. Biochem, Tokyo, 1939, 30: 159-79.—Hofstee, J. P. [The influence of formation of hippuric acid on metabolism in man] Ned. tschr. geneesk, 1924, 68: 1139-44.—Kingsbury, F. B. The synthesis and excretion of hippuric acid; the glvcine factor. Proc. Soc Exp. Biol, N. Y, 1922-23, 20: 405-8.—Klemme, C. J, & Hunter, J. H. Synthesis of iodohippuric acids; 2,5-, 3,5- and 3,4- dhodohippuric acids. J. Org. Chem, 1940, 5: 227-34. ------ Synthesis of iodohippuric acids; 2, 3, 5- and 3, 4, 5- tniodohippuric acids. Ibid, 508-11.—Koch, C. E. Hat die aktuelle Reaktion des Harns einen Einfluss auf den Umfang der Hippursauresynthese? Arch. exp. Path, Lpz, 1927, 121: 83-8.—Lackner, E, Levinson, A, & Morse, W. The role of the liver in hippuric acid synthesis. Biochem. J, Cambr, 1918, 12: 184-9.—Lautemann. Trasformazione dell'acido chinico in acido ippurico neH'organismo. Gior. farm, chim. Tor, 1864. 13: 76.—Lewis, H. B. Studies on the synthesis of hippuric acid in the animal organism; a note on the synthesis of hippuric acid in the rabbit after exclusion of bile from the intestine. J. Biol. Chem, 1921, 46: 73-5.—Lissitzyn, F. [Origin of hippuric acid in the urine of herbivorous animals] J. eksp. biol, 1930, 14: 54- 60.—Neuweiler, W. Ueber die Hippursaure-Synthese in der normalen Schwangerschaft und im Wochenbett. Klin. Wschr, 1939, 18: 1050-2. ------ Ueber Hippursauresynthese bei Gestosen. Ibid, 1940, 19: 135 (microfilm)—Sekine, M. Beitrage zur Kenntnis der Hippursaurebildung im Tieror- ganismus. Zschr. physiol. Chem, 1927, 164: 226-35.— Snapper, I, Grunbaum, A, & Neuberg, J. [The role of the kidney in the formation of hippuric acid in man, dog, hog, and sheep] Ned. tschr. geneesk, 1923, 67: 426-32.—Stekol, J. A. Conversion of dibenzyl disulfide to hippuric acid in the rat. Proc. Soc. Exp. Biol, N. Y, 1940, 45: 693-5.—Tronchetti, F. Le influenze insulopancreatiche su la sintesi dell'acido ippurico; ricerche su soggetti sani, su diabetici, su epatopazienti. Arch. stud, fisiopat. ricambio, 1939, 7: 261-85.—Tulane, V. J, Christman, A. A, & Lewis, H. B. Studies in the synthesis of hippuric acid in the animal organism; hydrazine intoxication and hippuric acid synthesis in the rabbit. J. Biol. Chem. 1933, 103: 141-50.—Vaccaro, P. F. The synthesis of hippuric acid; its value in detecting hepatic damage secondary to diseases of the extrahepatic biliary system. Surg. Gyn. Obst, 1935, 61: 36-42.—Widmark, E. M. P. Ueber den Einfluss der Nahrung auf die Hippursauresynthese beim Menschen. Biochem. Zschr, 1926, 179: 272-5.—Widmark, E, & Jensen-Carlen, K. De l'influence du metabolisme des hydrates de carbone sur la synthase de l'acide hippurique. C. rend. Soc. biol, 1924, 90: 1185. HIPPURICASE. Ellis, S, & Walker, B. S. The action of hippuricase on ring- substituted derivatives of hippuric acid. J. Biol. Chem, 1942, 142: 291-7. HIPPUS. See Iridodonesis. HIRANANDANI, Kaku M. Medical defence. p. 1. 8p. incl. portr. 18^cm. [Hyderabad, Sind, Moti Electric Print. Works, 1939] HIRCHBERG, A. See Pauchet, Victor, & Hirchberg, A. Cancer d'estomac. 184p. 8? Par, 1928. Also Pauchet, Victor, Luquet, Gabriel, & Hirchberg, A. ITlceres de l'estomac et du duodenum [&c] 350p. 8? Par, 1929. HIRCHERT, Johannes, 1891- *Der Einfluss der individuellen Faktoren bei der Wurzelbehandlung mit Hochfrequenzstrom. 32p. pl. 8? Berl. [n. pub.] 1932. HIRCISMUS. See Perspiration, Odor. HIRDES, Georg [Wilhelm] 1906- *Ueber freie Knorpeltransplantation [Kiel] 15p.. 231/2em. Grossenhain, H. Plasnick, 1932. HIRIART Corvalen, Oscar. *De los estados intersexuales [Univ. Chile] 112p. 8? Val- paraiso, Impr. M. Kegan & cia, 1930. HIRLEMANN, Arnold. *Sur l'ictere hemoly- tique constitutionnel et la spienectomie. 39p. 8? Geneve, B. Schwabe & co., 1933. Also Schweiz. med. Wschr, 1933, 63: 1309-15. HIRN, Walter, 1913- *Ueber Hauter- krankungen mit vermindertem Blutcalciumspiegel. [Heidelberg] 35p. 22cm. Wiirzb., R. Mayr, 1938. HIRSBRINNER i 06 HIRSCH HIRSBRl NNER, Hans, 1910- *Ueber das (Gleichgewicht der thermischen Dissoziation der Salicvlsaure [Zurich] p.477-504. 8? Basel, E. Birkhtiuser & cie, 1934. HIRSCH, Adolphe, 1910- *EfTets de l'eau d'Uriage en injection intratissulaire, chez les tuberculeux pulmonaires traites par l'auro- therapie [Paris] G3p. 8? Gap, L. Jean, 1936. HIRSCH, Arnold, 1901- *Zur Frage der Rontgenbiologie der Ovarien besonders in genera- tivcr und eugenetischer Hinsicht (Reizbestrah- lung, temporare Sterilisation) [Berlin] 25p. 8? Lpz., C. Kabitzsch, 1925. HIRSCH, Bruno, 1903- *Ueber eine seltene Missbildung der Scheide [Munchen] 17p. 8° Borna-Lpz., R. Noske, 1930. HIRSCH, Caesar, 1885-1940. Lehrbuch der Lokalanasthesie des Ohres und der oberen Luft- und Speisewege. xvi, 293p. 8? Stuttg., F. Enke, 1P25. For biography see Med. Rec, N. Y, 1941, 154: 317 (S. R. Kagan) HIRSCH, Carl, 1870-1931. Oehme, C. Biography. Med. KUn, Berl, 1930, 26: 451.— Romberg. Nekrulog. Deut. Arch. klin. Med, 1931, 170: p. i-vi.—Slauck. Nekrolog. Miinch. med. Wschr, 1931, 78: 158. HIRSCH, Charles Theodore William, 1869- 1927. Obituary. Lancet, Lond, 1927, 2: 301. HIRSCH, Edwin, 1908- ""Contribution a l'examen radiologique de la v^sicule et des voies biliaires. 75p. 8° Par., E. Le Francois, 1937. HIRSCH, Edwin Walter, 1892- A non- surgical consideration of prostatic enlargement, including a lecture on the myth of the bladder neck bar. vii, 79p. 8? Minneapolis, Bruce pub. co., 1931. ---- Sex life in Babylonia. 36 [2]p. 22cm. Chic, Research Pub., 1941. HIRSCH [Elisabeth] Charlotte, 1899- *Die Eigenbluttherapie und ihr Einfluss auf das Blutbild. 42p. tab. 8? Berl., E. Ebering, 1926. HIRSCH, Francis F. Neurological notes, v. p. illust. 8? Elizabeth, N. J., the Author, 1934. Mimeographed. HIRSCH, Franz, 1898- *Drei Falle von Hernia diaphragmatica congenita. 16p. 8? [Berl., n. pub.] 1927. HIRSCH, Franz, 1913- *Untersuchungen iiber die desinfizierende Kraft der Zahnpasten [Munchen] 24p. 22}£cm. Straubing, C. Atten- kofer, 1935. HIRSCH, Georg. Die Brustdriise in ihrer Beziehung zur inneren Sekretion. p.530-57. Lpz., C. Kabitzsch, 1928. In 1 Halfte, 3 Bd, Handb. inn. Sekret. (Hirsch) HIRSCH, Gottwalt Christian, 1888- Form- und Stoffwechsel der Golgi-Korper. xi, 394p. incl. illust. tab. 22}£cm. Berl., Gebr. Born- traeger, 1939. Bd 18, Protoplasma-Monogr. See al^o Jordan, Hermann J, & Hirsch, G. C. Lebungen aus cler vergleichenden Physiologie [&c] 272p. 8°. Berl, 1927. HIRSCH, Hanna, 1909- *Zur Wurzel- fiillung mit Radisan [Leipzig] 28p. 8? Zeulen- roda, A. Oberreuter, 1932. HIRSCH, Hans, 1904- *Beitrag zur Entstehung des Gallenblasencarcinoms [Frank- furt] 39p. 8? Heidelb. [n. pub.] 1928. HIRSCH, Heinz, 1909- *Ueber das Gahnen [Berlin] 20p. 2 1. 8? Jena, G. Neuenhahn, 1933. HIRSCH, Henri. Neuland in der Heilkunde. 87p. 8? Basel, S. Karger, 1937. HIRSCH, Herbert, 1909- *Ueber die Tranenkanalspulung beim Hund. 2Sp. 8? Lpz., A. Edelmann, 1935. HIRSCH, Hermann, 1905- *Die Be- einflussung der Serumeiweiss-Konzentration und -Fraktion des menschlichen Blutes durch Dia- thermie [Freiburg i. B.] 16p. 8? [Hamb., Niemann & Moschinski] 1930. HIRSCH [Isaac Seth] 1S79-1P42. Die peri- pheren Blutgefasse im Rontgenbild unter Beriick- sichtigung der Injektionsmethode am lebenden Menschen (nach Berberich und Hirsch) viii 72p. 6 pl. 8? Frankf. a. M., Keim & Nemnich' 1924. For biographv see J. Am. M. Ass, 1942, 119: 97. Also Radiology, 1942, 38: 620, portr. (Poppel, M. II.) HIRSCH, Johannes, 1903- *Zur Kehl- kopfstenose nach Typhus. 63p. 8? Konigsb E. Rautenberg, 1932. HIRSCH, John J., 1907- *Die Dosenbe- stimmung bei Radiumbehandlung des Kollum- karzinoms; vergleichende Untersuchung der in Paris und Stockholm geiibten Methodik. ">0p 8? Ziir., L. Schumacher, 1938. Also Strahlentherapie, 1938, 61: HIRSCH, Julian, 1906- *Das primare Tubenkarzinom. 31p. 8? Bresl., L. Freund 1931. HIRSCH, Konrad, 1898- *Beitrag zum Hallux varus congenitus und seiner Behandlung 39p. 23cm. Berl., R. Pfau, 1936. HIRSCH, Kurt, 1908- *Die Kupfer- resistenz der Spirochaten vom Weil-Typ und Versuche iiber die Reinziichtung von Wasser- spirochaten auf Kupfernahrboden [Freiburg] p.459-72. 8? Jena, G. Fischer, 1931. Also Zschr. Immunforsch, 1931, 71: HIRSCH, Leon Lucien, 1903- *Cephal6es et algies cranio-faciales d'origine nasale. 96p 8? Par., L. Arnette, 1929. HIRSCH, Luise, 1904- *Ueber eine Sonderform der Transposition der grossen Gefasse [Berlin] 30p. 8? Charlottenb., Gebr. Hoffmann, 1932. HIRSCH, Madeleine, 1887- *Douleurs cellulitiques et menopause (contribution clinique k l'etude de la douleur) 93p. 8? Par., A. Legrand, 1928. HIRSCH, Max, 1877- Die Gattenwahl: ein arztlicher Ratgeber bei der Eheschliessung; hrsg. unter Forderung des Landesausschusses fur hygienische Volksbelehrung. 42p. 8? Lpz., C. Kabitzsch, 1922. ' ---- Handbuch der inneren Sekretion; eine umfassende Darstellung der Anatomie, Physio- logie und Pathologie der endokrinen Drusen. 3v. in 5. 8? Lpz., C. Kabitzsch, 1928-33. ---- Mutterschaftsfursorge. 218p. 8? Lpz., C. Kabitzsch, 1931. Forms H. 15, Monogr. Frauenk. & Konst. ---- Alte und neue Heilkunde im Lichte der Lehre von der inneren Sekretion. p.4-24. Lpz., C. Kabitzsch, 1932. In Bd 1, Handb. inn. Sekret. (Hirsch) See also Dietrich, E, & Hirsch, Max. Rhcuma-Jahrbuoh, 1929-1930/31. 2v. 263p.; 196p. 8? Berl. [1929-31] Also editor of Monographien zur Frauenkunde und Eugene- tik, Sexualbiologie und Vererbungslehre. Lpz, Heft 1-6, 1921-24. Also of Zeitschrift fur wissenschaftliche Baderkunde. Berl, v.1-4, 1926/27-1929/30. See also Posner, C. Max Hirsch zum 50. Geburtstag. Arch. Frauenk, 1927, 13: 1-3, portr. HIRSCH, Nathaniel David Mitron, 1896- An experimental study upon 300 school children over a 6-year period; from the Department of HIRSCH 707 HIRSCHEL Psychology of Duke University. p.487-549. 24^em. Worcester, Mass., Clark Univ. [1930] In No. 6, v.7. Genet. Psychol. Monogr. ' ---- Genius and creative intelligence. 339p. 8? Cambr., Mass., Science Art Pub., 1931. ---- Dynamic causes of juvenile crime. 250p. 8°. Cambr., Mass., Science Art Pub. [1937] HIRSCH, Otto, 1902- *Beitrag zur Frage der Speicherung von Jod im tierischen Organismus bei peroraler Zufuhr kleiner Mengen vorzugs- weise organisch gebundenen Jods. 28p. 8° Munch, [n. pub.] 1927. HIRSCH, Raymond Stephen, 1904- *Status lymphaticus and the relation of the thymus gland to this disease [Marquette Univ.] lip. 4? Milwaukee, 1930. Typewritten. HIRSCH, Robert, 1902- *Des actions experimentales et therapeutiques obtenues par les injections intra-veineuses lentes de scrums physiologiques acidifies. 58p. 24cm. Par., Maloine, 1938. HIRSCH, Rudolf, 1902- *Der Einfluss der Lipoide auf das Blutbild. p.796-802. 8? Berl., J. Springer, 1928. HIRSCH, Rudolph, 1909- *Die Ge- schichte der atiologischen Auffassungen der Paradentose, speziell der Alveolarpyorrhoe [Leipzig] 95p. 23cm. Radebeul, Kupky & Dietze, 1936. HIRSCH, Sigismond, 1906- *Etude stereoradiographique de la muqueuse gastrique par le thorium. 130p. 12 pl. 8? Par., Le Francois, 1933. HIRSCH, Trude, 1904- *Ueber Spontan- heilung von malignen Tumoren. 26p. 8? Berl. [n. pub.] 1933. HIRSCH, Werner, 1908- *Die Tuber- kulose der Symphyse. 19p. 2 pl. 8? Konigsb., J. Raabe, 1935. HIRSCH-BARASCH, Sophie, 1899- *Blasenmole und Chorionepitheliom. 59p. 8? Bresl., Bresl. Genoss. Buchdr., 1931. HIRSCHBERG, Andre, 1899- *Les rap- ports azoturiques et leur valeur dans l'exploration de la fonction ureogenique du foie. 57p. 8? Par., Impr. Labor, 1926. HIRSCHBERG, Elly Louise. *Ueber die Wirkung des Blutfarbstoffes und einiger anderer Blutfarbstoffderivate auf den Grundumsatz des Kaninchens. 15p. 8? Stetten, K. Schahl, 1935. HIRSCHBERG, Else, 1892- *Beitrage zur Kenntnis der Pharmakologie von Convallaria majalis. 89p. 8? Rostock, R. Beckmann, 1928. HIRSCHBERG, Julius, 1843-1925. Geschichte der Augenheilkunde. Bd 12-14, Abt. 1-7; Bd 15, Abt. 1-2. In Handb. ges. Augenh. (Grffife-Sa;misch) 2. Aufl, Lpz, 1899-1918. ---- Aus jungen Tagen (Erlebnisse und Erin- nerungen) 44p. 8? Berl., W. Junk, 1923. HIRSCHBERG, Nikolai. Fleckfieber und Nervensystem. 124p. 8? Berl., S. Karger, 1932. Forms H. 66, Abh. Neur. Psychiat. HIRSCHBOECK, Elizabeth Josephine, 1903- Relationship between chronic gastric ulcer and carcinoma [S. Francis Hosp.] Up. 4? La Crosse, Wis., 1928. Typewritten. HIRSCHBOECK, John Stephen, 1910- *Primary carcinoma of the lung [Milwaukee Co. Hosp.] 9p. 8? Milwaukee, 1937. Typewritten. HIRSCHEL, Annie, 1907- *Die Arbeits- therapie der Tuberkulosen [Breslau] 57p 21cm. Ohlau, H. Eschenhagen, 1933. HIRSCHEL, Georg, 1875- Lehrbuch der Lokalanasthesie, fur Studierende und Aerzte 1923Ufl" Vl' 164P' 8? Miinch-' J" F' Bergmann, HIRSCHEL, Hermann. *Ueber Metastasen ernes Uteruscarcinoms in bestrahlter Haut [Bern] 36p. 2l^cm. Thun, G. Aeschlimann, 1940. HIRSCHELMANN, Fritz, 1906- *Ueber einige besondere Indikationen der Jejunal- sondenbehandlung. 19p. 21cm. Rostock, C. Hinstorff, 1937. HIRSCHER [Willy] Herbert, 1911- *Ueber die Wirkung des Edestins und des be- strahlten Edestins auf den Betriebsstoffwechsel nach Massgabe der Lage der Harnquotienten C/N und Vacat-O/N. 24p. 23cm. Berl., F. Linke, 1936. HIRSCHFELD, Alexander, 1905- *Be- richt uber die operativ behandelten Falle von Glaucoma simplex an der Universitats-Augen- klinik zu Wurzburg 1925-29. 22p. 8? Wiirzb , M. Walther & co., 1930. HIRSCHFELD, Ernst Georg, 1899- *Angina pectoris saturnina. p.698-712. 8? Berl., J. Springer, 1926. Also Zschr. klin. Med, 1926, 104: HIRSCHFELD, Friedrich, 1753-18-? Klein-Endebrock [J.] W. *Die Bedeutung Friedrich Hirschfelds fiir die praktische und theoretische Zahnheilkunde [Munchen] 55p. 21^cm. Bramsche, 1936. HIRSCHFELD, Hans, 1873-1929. Die Er- krankungen der Milz. 609p. 8? Berl., J. Springer, 1920. Forms 6. T, Enzykl. klin. Med. (Langstein, von Noorden [et al.]) ---- Lehrbuch der Blutkrankheiten fiir Aerzte und Studierende. 2. Aufl. viii, 263p. 5 pl. 8? Lpz., J. A. Barth, 1928. ---- Die Bluttransfusion als Heilfaktor. 45p. 8? Halle, C. Marhold, 1932. Forms H. 1, v.12, Samml. Verdauungskr. For biography see Sang. Par, 1929, 3: 51 (P. Chevallier) ---- & HITTMAIR, A. Handbuch der allge- meinen Hamatologie. 2v. in 4. illust. pl. diagrs. 8? Berl., Urban & Schwarzenberg, 1932-34. HIRSCHFELD, Hans, & MUEHSAM, R. Chirurgie der Milz. xii, 274p. 8? Stuttg., F. Enke, 1930. HIRSCHFELD, Hans, 1908- *Ueber die Verweildauer verschiedener Milchgemische im Sauglingsmagen. 14p. 8? Gott., 1933. HIRSCHFELD, Use. *Ueber Empyeme bei Leberabszessen [Basel] 15p. 8? Berl., L. Schumacher, 1935. HIRSCHFELD, Isador, 1881- The tooth- brush: its use and abuse; a treatise on preventive dentistry and periodontia as related to dental hygiene. 4 p. 1. vii-xvi, 591p. illust. diagr. 25cm. Brooklyn, Dent. Items of Interest Pub. co., 1939. HIRSCHFELD, Ludwig. *Ueber Anaphy- laxie und Anaphylatoxin und ihre Beziehungen zu den Gerinnungsvorgangen [Habilitations- schrift] p.15-43. 8? Zur., Zurcher & Furrer, 1914. HIRSCHFELD, Magnus, 1868-1935. Ge- schlechtskunde, auf Grund dreissigjahriger For- schung und Erfahrung. 3. Bd. 4? Stuttg., J. Puttmann, 1926-30. HIRSCHFELD 708 HIRSCH MANN ---- The same. Bd 5: Registerteil. p. 1. 232p. 2 1. 4? Stuttg., J. Puttmann, 1930. ----Sexualitat und Kriminalitat; Ueberblick iiber Verbrechen geschlechtlichen Ursprungs. lOlp. 8? Wien, Yerl. Renaissance, 1924. ---- Geschlecht und Verbrechen. 410p. illust. 8? Lpz., Schneider ilit6 a l'acetvl- choline. C. rond. Soc. biol, 1936, 121: 220.—Du Buisson, & Van den Bcrghe, L. Modifications experimentales du tonus des muscles longitudinaux sous-cntaiies de la sangsue medicinale. Arch, internat. phvsiol.. Liege, 1927, 29: 19-21.—Harant, H, & Vcrnieres, P. Metacercaires parasites de sangsues. Arch. Soc. sc. med. biol. Montpellier, 1934-35, 16: 234.—Herlcr. K. Deutsche' Egel und ihre Beziehungen zum Menschen. Med. Klin, Berl, 1932, 28: 1037-40. —--- Fang, Pflege und Zuel.t der deutschen Siisswasseregel. In Handb. biol. Arbeitsmeth. (Abderhalden) Berl., 1930, 9: pt 2, 1577-618.------Leber (•eotaxis und l'hotoiaxis deutscher Egel. Zool. Anz, 1929, Suppl, Bd 4, 72 S2. Ishisawa, M. Contribution il l'etude des fibres musculaires de la sangsue. C. rend. Soc. biol, 1926, 94: 177.—Lafargue, M. Les acides gras volatils excretes par la sangsue k jeun vivant avec ou sans oxygerie. Ibid, 193 I, 116: 51-6. ------ & Fayemcndy, M. Sur l'excretion carbonee organique de la sangsue k jeun et alimentee. Ibid, 1932, 111: 183. ------ Los modifications de l'excretion carbon6c organique de la sangsue sous Taction de la privation d'oxygene. Ibid, 185.- Miller. J. A. Studies in the biology of the leech; behavior following nerve cord transection. Ohio J. Sc, 1942, 42: 45-52.- Minz, B. Pharmakologische Untersuchungen ani Blutcgelpriiparat, zugleich eine Methode zum biologischen Nachweis von Azctykholin bei Anwesenheit anderer pharmako- logisc h wirksamer koi pereigencr StofTe. Arch. exp. Path, Berl. 1932, 168: 292-304- Moore, J. P. Laboratorv care of leeches' ln Cult. Meth. Invertebr. (GaltsofT, P. S, [et al.)) Ithaca, 1937, 201-4.—Peruzzi, P., & Colombini, N. Sulla reattivita del muscolo dorsale di sanguisuga in un particolare periodo dell'an- no. Boll. Soc. ital. biol. sper, 1938, 13: 968-70.—Pinto, C. Technica para o estudo das sanguesugas. Sciencia med. Rio 1923, 1:44 .—Putter, A. Der Stoffwechsel des Blutegels (Hirudo medieinalis L.) Zschr. allg. Physiol, 1907, 7: 16-61.—Reib- stein, H. Ueber Bau und Tatigkeit der Kiefer von Hirudo medieinalis L. Zool. Jahrb, Abt. Anat, 1931, 54: 55-104, 2 pl.—Rondinini, R. Saggio di dimostrazioni delle neurofibrils nella Punktsubstanz di Hirudo medieinalis con il metodo II. del Donaggio. Riv. pat. nerv, 1934, 43: 279-81.—Schweizeri G. Bacillus hirudinis, ein spezifischer Symbiont des Blutegels Arch. Mikrob, Berl, 1936, 7: 235-40.—Spiess, C. La question du foie chez la sangsue medicinale; recherches experimentales sur l'excretion. C. rend. Soc. biol, 1905, 8: 577-9. ------ Sur la presence de pigments biliaires chez la sangsue medicinale. C. rend. Acad, sc, 1905, 141: 333-5.—Truszkowski, R. The purinolytic enzymes of the leech (Hirudo medieinalis) and the fresh-water mussel (Anodonta) Biochem. J, Lond, 1928, 22: 1299-301.—Whitman, C. O. The external morphology of the leech. Proe. Am. Acad. Arts Sc, 1884-85, n. ser, 12: 76-87, pl.—Zick, K. Weiteres iiber Zucht und Fortpflanzung des medizinischen Blutegels. Zool. Anz, 1933, 103: 49-55. ---- Therapeutic use. See also Hirudin. Chambrox, P. *La sangsue mddicinale, Hirudo medieinalis; conservation en officine; applications medicales et v£terinaires [Lyon] 117p. 25cm. Trevoux, 1938. Dahlhavs, H. *Zur Blutegelbehandlung in der Geburtshilfe und Gynakologie. 39p. 8° Bonn, 1935. _ RoTTEXREKfi, IL Die Blutegflbchandlung; ein vielscitiges Verfahren der biologischen Medi- zin. 12Sp. 8? Stuttg., 1935. Bottenbcrg, H. Erfahrungen in der Blutegelbehandlung Hippokrates, Stuttg., 193 1,5: 162-74. ------ Handhabung der Blutegelhehandhmg. Med. Welt, 1935, 9: 647. —-__ Wissenschaftln he und praktische Fragen zur Blutegelbehand- lung. Hippokrates, Stuttg, 1936, 7: 677-85.------Aus- leitung und Umstimmungdurch Blutentziehungen; Blutegelbe- handlung. In his Biol. Ther, Munch, 1936, 235-44. —■___ Indikationserweiterung der Blutegelbehandlung. Munch, med Wschr, 1936, 83: 127-30.—Bruns, H. Klinische und experi- mentelle Untersuchungen zur Frage der Blutegeltherapie Zschr. ges. exp. Med, 1937, 101: 484-92.—Dinand, F„ & Bottenberg.H. Experimentelle Studien zur Blutegolbchandliing Med. Welt, 1935, 9: 1147-9.—Ducuing, J, Soula, <:. [et al.! Contribution k l'etude experimentale de l'hirudinisation. Sang Par, 1928, 2: 240-52.—Hempel, C. Die medizinische An! wendung des Blutegels im Wandcl der Zeiten mit neueren Da ten aus Zoologie, Phvsiologie und Pharmakologie. Med Welt 1934, 8: 210-2.—Hoeppli, R., & Tang, G. G. Leeches in old Chinese and European medical literature. Chin. M J 1941 59: 359-78, 2 pl. (microfilm)— Ichok, G. El empleo de las sanguijuelas en el tratamiento de las flebitis. Arch, med Madr, 1928, 28: 747-52.—Indicazioni del sanguisugio. Gazz' osp, 1936, 57: 225-7.—Lehfeldt, H. Technik der Blutentzic- hung durch Blutegel. Ther. Gegenwart, 1931, 72: 536-9.— Leuze, A. M. Technik der Blutegelbehandlung. Munch mod Wsehr, 1936, 83: 315-7. ------ Die Blutegelbehandlung iri der Heilstatte. Ibid, 1937, 84: 643-5.—Milbradt, W. Ueber die Verwendung der entzundungshemmenden Eigenschaft (ler Blutegel zur Behandlung von Hautkrankheiten. Derm. Wschr 1936, 103: 1057-60.—Moebius, P. G. Wann uml Wie der Blutegelbehandlung. Zschr. arztl. Fortbild, 1935, 32: 687.— Remijnse, J. G. [Therapy with leeches] Ned. tschr. geneesk 1939, 83: 37-42.—Romano, G. Utilita del sanguisugio. Policlinico, 1926, 33: sez. prat, 728.—Riidigor. Zur Blutegel- behandlung. Munch, med. Wschr., 1936, 83: 1276.—Saka- euchi, K. [The leech used in medicine] Binsho jakuseki shimpo, Tokyo, 1905 6, 1 : 385-93.—Schubert, M. Blutegel- behandlung bei Epididymitideu und Arthritis gonorrhoea Derm. Wschr, 1937, 105: 917--21.— Ser, I. [Therapeutic use of leeches] Warsz. czas. lek, 1938, 15: 764-7.—Nncgirev, Y. [Leeches in gynecological piaelice] Vrach. gaz, 1906 13- 1075; 1908, 15: 269—Stiihli, R. Untersuchungen iiber den Einfluss do Blutcgelapplikation auf die Phagozytose der Blutleukozyten; ein Beitrag zur Kenntnis der Blutegelwirkung Ausz. Inaugur. Diss. Med. Fak. Univ. Bern (1931-33) 1934J No. 55, 1 3. -Tibbies, S. The use of leeches in eye diseases Brit. M. .1, 1935, 2: 785.—Vandorfy, J. [Recent experience with leech therapy] Orv. hetil, 1936, 80: mell, 45.—Wissen- schaftliche Grundlagen fur die Wirkung der Blutegelbehand- lung; Behandlungsanzeigen. Praxis, Bern, 1935, 24: 302-5. ---- Vector of infection. Hecht, G. Blutegel als Uebcrtrager von Krankheitserregern. Hippokrates, Stuttg, 1930-31, 3: 624-6.—Lutz, A, & de Oliveira Castro, G. M. ConsideracSes sobre a transmissao de doencas por sugadores de sangue. Fol. med, Rio, 1936, 17: 320-8.—Pavesi, C. Delia disinfettazione delle sanguisughe gia usate. Gior. farm, chim, 1873, 22: 529-32.—Wagner, R. Ueber die Verweildauer von Syphilisspirochiiten im Blutegel. Derm. Zschr, 1934, 70: 11-3. HIRVONEN, Martti. *Ueber die Reizbarkeit des Gesamtmuskels bei elektrischer Reizung; die Ueberschwellen- und Schwellenzuckungen bei Reizung des Froschmuskels mit Kondensatorent- ladungen und rechtwinkligen Stromstossen [Hel- sinki] 99p. 8? Berl., W. de Gruyter & co., Also Skand. Arch. Physiol, Berl, 1932, 64: HIRZEL, Artur. *Die Sensibilitat der Pars copulationis des weiblichen Genitale. p. 102-23. 8? Basel, 1932. Also Arch. Gynak, 1932, 149: HIRZEL, Gertrud. *Beitrag zur Kasuistik der Adamantinoma. 45p. 8? Zur., Gebr. Leemann & co., 1929. HIRZLE, Maurice. For portrait, see Med. dent. Canton Vaud (0. Lazar) Geneve, 1938, p. 39. HIS, Wilhelm, 1831-1904. His, W., jr. Wilhelm His der Anatom: ein Lebensbild. 79p. 8? Berl., 1931. Bast, T H. William His; 1831-1904. Q. Phi Beta Pi M. £ratern, 1942 39: 19-32, portr.—Corning. H. K. [Biography] Khn. Wschr., 1931, 10: 1271,-Gerez, L. Nota biogrffica de ™le™° His el anat6mico. Tr. Cated. hist. crit. med, Madr, 19c54-35, 4: 447-54, portr.—Publications of William Hii ?£ong22 '" chronological order. Q. Phi Beta Pi M. Fratern., 1942, 39: 32-7. HIS 711 HISPINAE For portrait," photograph, see Collection in library. Also Q. Phi Beta Pi M. Fratern, 1942, 39: 22-23. HIS, Wilhelm, 1863-1934. Die Front der Aerzte. 250p. 2 map. 8? Bielefeld, Velhagen & Klasing, 1931. ---- The same. A German doctor at the front (Die Front der Aerzte) transl. from German by Gustavus M. Blech and Jefferson R. Kean. 7 p. 1. 230p. portr. maps. 8? Wash., Nat. Serv. Pub. co. [1933] ---- Wilhelm His der Anatom; ein Lebens- bild. iv, 79p. portr. 8? Berl., Urban & Schwarzenberg, 1931. Mello, S. Necrologio. Brasil-med, 1935, 49: 128-30 (S Mello) Also Deut. Arch. khn. M, 1934-35, 177: p. i-viii (V. Schilling) Also Deut. med. Wschr, 1934, 60: 1895 (R. von der Velden) Also In Cardiac Classics (Willius, F. A.) S Louis, 1941, 692-4, portr. Also Klin. Wschr, 1934, 13: 1689-92. Also Lancet, Lond, 1934, 2: 1200. Also Med. Klin, Berl 1934, 30: 1578. Also Mil. Surgeon, Wash, 1935, 76: 99 (G. M. Blech) Also Miinch. med. Wschr, 1933, 80: 2044, portr. (L. von Krehl) Also Presse med, 1935, 43: 854 (J. G. C.) Also Schweiz. med. Wschr, 1935, 65: 267 (A. Lotz) Also Wien. med. Wschr, 1935, 85: 688 (W. Falta) Also Zschr. arztl. Fortbild, 1933, 30: 715 (V. Schilling) Also Zschr. khn. Med, 1933-34, 126: 195 (von Bergmann) HIS' BUNDLE. See Heart conduction. HISCOCK, Ira Vaughn, 1892- A survey of health and welfare activities in Honolulu, Hawaii, including official and voluntary agencies under the auspices of the United Welfare Fund. 160p. 8? [New Haven, Conn., Quinipiack press] 1929. ---- An appraisal of the public health pro- gram, San Francisco, California, for the fiscal year, 1929-30. 115p. 8? [n. p., 1930?] ---- Merriam memorial survey of tubercu- losis control in Cleveland, Ohio, for the year 1930; a survey of the program for the prevention and treatment of tuberculosis in Cleveland. 86p. 8? [Cleveland] [1931] ---- Community health organization; a manual of administration and procedure for cities of 100,000, with suggested modifications for larger and smaller urban units, x p. 2 1. 261p. pl. 23^cm. N. Y., Commonwealth fund, 1932. Also 3. ed. xvi, 318p. incl. form. tab. 1939. ---- District health administration; a study of organization and planning, x, 115p. illust. tab. 8? Lancaster, Pa., Milbank Mem. Fund, 1936. , „ ---- Health field day, Greenwich, Conn., September 15, 1937. 5 1. 27cm. [New Haven, Conn.] 1937. „ ^ _ , Mimeographed; forms No. 3, v.16, Contr. Dep. Pub. Health Yale. ---- A survey of public health activities in Colorado Springs and El Paso County, Colorado, including official and voluntary agencies. 143p. pl. 22^cm. Colorado Springs, Community Chest of the Pikes Peak Region, 1937. Forms No. 6, v.16, Contr. Dep. Pub. Health Yale. ---- CONNOLLY, Mary P. [et al.] Ways to community health education, x p. 306p. incl. illust. form. pl. diagr. 24cm. N. Y., Common- wealth Fund, 1939. Avri m ^_, HISCOX, Gardner D., & SLOANE, T. O'Con- nor. Fortunes in formulas for home, farm, and workshop, viii, xxxviii, 857p.; [25]p. portr. 22cm. N. Y., Books Inc. [1939] HISHIDA, Seiji [George] 1874- ^ Fourth report on progress in Manchuria to 1934. vii, 294p. illust. pl. maps. 4? Dairen, South Manchuria Railw., 1934. HISPINAE. See also Insect. Maulik, S. New injurious Hispinae. Bull. Entom. Res, Lond, 1929-30, 20: 81-94. HISS, A. Emil, & EBERT, Albert E. The new standard formulary, comprising in part 1 all preparations, official or included in the pharmacopeias, dispensatories or formularies of the world. 6. ed. by E. D. Irvine. 3 p. 1. 1256p. 8? Chic, G. P. Engelhard & co., 1926. HISS, John Martin, 1891- New feet for old; a simple statement of some recent and highly cheering discoveries concerning common foot disorders, their cause and cure, for the mutual use of physicians and patients. 3. ed. xxiip. 161p. illust. pl. 8? Garden City, N. Y., Doubleday, Doran & co., 1934. HISS BACILLUS. See under Dysentery bacillus. HISTAMINASE. See also Histamine, Chemistry. Spreyer, W. *Ueber die Bedeutung der Histaminase bei der Histaminbildung durch Leber und Niere [Greifswald] 20p. 8? Lenge- rich, 1938. Best, C. H, & McHenry, E. W. A note on histaminase. Canad. M. Ass. J, 1940, 43: 163.—Bosse, M. D. Effect of histaminase on the Shwartzman phenomenon. J. Lab. Clin. M, 1940-41, 26: 1432-4.—Effkemann, G, & Werle, E. Sig- nificance of diminished histaminase activity of the blood in pregnancy in initiating abortion. Am. J. Obst, 1942, 43: 353 (Abstr.)—Eustis, A. The relation of histaminase to in- testinal toxemia and asthma; preliminary report. N. Orleans M. & S. J, 1939-40, 92: 349-51.—Felix, J. Experimental and clinical investigations of the action of histaminase con- tained in extracts of the mucous membrane of the intestines on histamine. Acta med. scand, 1938, 95: 1-15.—Frank, D. E., & Harris, M. C. Histaminase; experimental and clinical studies. Med. Chn. N. America, 1941, 25: 849-62—Green- baum. S. S. Local anaphylactic (Arthus?) phenomena from parenteral injections of histaminase. J.-Am. M. Ass, 1940, 115: 847.—Histaminase. Brit. M. J, 1941, 1: 324—McHenry, E. W, & Gavin, G. Studies on histaminase. Tr. R. Soc. Canada, Biol. Sc, 1931, 3. ser, 25: Sect. 5, 101-9. ------ Histaminase; further studies in purification; source of the ammonia formed in the histamine-histaminase reaction. Biochem. J, Lond, 1935, 29: 622-5.—Miller, H, Hawes, R. C, & Piness, G. Histaminase in allergy; a study of its effects on skin reactivity to histamine and to allergens. J. Allergy, 1940-41, 12: 335-45.—Necheles, H, Olson, W. H, & Scruggs, W. Histaminase; an experimental study. Am. J. Digest. Dis, 1941, 8: 217-9.—Preliminary report on hista- minase; torantil. J. Am. M. Ass, 1940, 115: 1019-21.— Rose, B, Karady, S, & Browne, J. S. L. The histaminase oontent of the tissues of the rat and the effect of histamine pretreatment. Am. J. Physiol, 1940, 129: 219-25.—Tachi- kawa, K, & Nakashima, S. Experimentelle Studien iiber Histaminase beim pathologischen Zustand. Jap. J. M. Sc, 1934-36, 4: Surg. &c, 222.—Vaisberg, M. Histaminase; further laboratory studies. J. Lab. Clin. M, 1941-42, 27: 628-34.—Vaughan, E. W, & Blanton, W. B. Studies in hista- minase; the effect of histaminase on the histamine wheal. North Carolina M. J, 1941, 2: 116-9.—Wer,Ie, E, Madlener, M. J, & Herrmann, H. Ueber das Verhalten der Histidin- carboxylase und Histaminase bei Nierenschadigungen; Harn- leiterstauung bei Meerschweinchen. Zschr. ges. exp. Med, 1939, 106: 105-10. ---- Therapeutic use. See also Allergy, Treatment; Colitis, Treat- ment, etc. Winthrop chemical company, inc. Torantil; treatment of allergies by detoxication of histamine with histaminase. 22p. 18^cm. [N. Y., 1939?] Ahlmark, A, & Kornerup, T. G. [Brief review of therapeutic results with histaminase; also a pharmacological test of torantil] Nord. med, 1939, 4: 3421-4.—Ahlmark, A, & Lornerup, T. G. Therapeutische Ergebnisse mit Histaminase. Klin. Wschr, 1940, 19: 121-3 (microfilm)—Alexander, H. L., & Bottom, D. The ' failure of histaminase to protect guinea-pigs against histamine and anaphylactic shock. J. Immun, Bait, 1940, 39: 457-60.—Baker, T. W. Experiences with histaminase, torantil; a preliminary report. North Carolina M. J, 1940, 1: HISTAMINASE 712 HISTAMINE 551--6.—Barlow. <>. W., & Homburger, E. The influence of histaminase on the course of anaphvlaxis and histamine shock in guinea pigs. J. Allergy, 1940- II, 12: 116-58.— Barton, R. E. Histaminase and allergic condition!-, with case n-i><>i ts. Pacific fViM M , 1940, 7: No. 2, 32-4. Cherry. J. H.. .V Prirkman, I, L. Tin- treatment and prevention of serum -irkiuw by the a ..f histaminase. Proc. Mayo Clin, 1941, 16: 38-40. l-'n\. 1-:. ('. Clinical and statistical evaluation of histaminuao. South. M. J, 1941, 34: 1124--7.—Gilbert, A. J, & Goldman, F. The effect of aminophyllin, histaminase, and nicotinic acid on histamine-poisoned puppv bronchioles; preliminary icpoit. Bull. John Sealv Hosp, Galvest, 1940, 2: 55- Gptzsche. P. [Torantil] Ugeskr. laeger, 1941, 103: 1400.—Haag, F. E, & Latz, I, Priifung des Histamin entgiftenden Darmsehleini- hautprnpaiates; Torantil im Anaph\ laxieversuch. Zschr. Immunfoiach, 1939, 96: 117 -25.- Hawes, K. C, Alles, G. A, & Miller. H. The question of protection against histamine and anaphylactic shock in guinea pins bv histaminase. J. Lab. Clin. M, 1941-42,27:337-12— Heidemann.H. [The histamin- checking effect of torantil] Ugeskr. laeger, 1940, 102: 834.— Knoll, A. F., & Beinhauer, L. G. Experimental and cUnical observations with histaminase. Arch. Derm. Syph, Chic, 1940, 42: 89i>-908. -Mori, N. Leber die Wirkungsweise von Histaminase. Okayama igakkai zasshi, 1935, 47: 413.— Muether, R. O, Mitchell, H. A. [et al.] Histaminase; clinical experiences in nonallelic diseases. J. Missouri M. Ass, 1941, 38: 89-93.—Reveno, W. S. Observations on the parenteral use ol histaminase. Harper Hosp. Bull, Detr, 1941-42, 1: 69. Rose, B, A: Browne, J. S. L. Effect of histaminase pretreatment on histamine shock in guinea pigs. J. Immun, Bait, 1941. 41: 4 \rrli exp. Path, Berl, 1940, 195: 245-57 (microfilm)- birhlrr. <>., & Spcda, G. Versuche iiber die Abhangigkeit dc 11 i-i.uiiin- irehaltes im Hint plasma von der Atmung. Ibid, 152 63, l mil•rofilm)— Ilildebrandt. F. Leber den Einfluss der Kurz- uclleu, der Diathermic und des Lango auf den Hislamingehalt im Blut und (leweho. Klin. Wschr, 1940, 19: 270 (microfilm)— Marcou, I, & Atanasiu-\ ergu, F. L'histamine dans le sang des paiturientes. Bull. Acad. med. Roumanie, 1937, 3: 359 65.— Revoltella, G. L'istamina nella placenta, nei sangue della gravida e del feto. Atti Soc. ital. ostet, 1927, 26: 254-7.— Rocha e Silva, M, & Essex, H. E. The effect of animal poisons, rattlesnake venom and tr\ psin, on the blood histamine of guinea pigs and rabbits. Am. J. Physiol, 19-11- 42, 135: 372-7.— Rose, B. On a sex difference of the histamine content of blood of the rat. Proc. Soc. Exp. Biol, N. Y, 1938-39, 39: 300.— Segal, G. Variations du taux d'histamine chez des malades soumis k un traitement, par rnvons X. C. rend. Soc. biol, 1939, 131: 1079.—Werle, E, A: EfTkcmann, G. Der Histamingchalt des Blutes von Rauchern. Klin. Wschr, 1940, 19: 1100-2 (microfilm) ---- Blood level: Variation, pathological. See also Allergy. Cerqua, S. L'equivalente istaminico nei sangue in diverse condizioni patologiche. Minerva med. Tor, 1936, 27: 512 8.—Den Hartog Jager, W. A. Des determinations pharma- cologiques de l'histamine dans le sang des schizophrenics et, de divers sujets de controle. Lliic6phale, 1939, 34: 149-60.— Marcou, I, Gingold, N, & Parhon, G. C, jr. L'histamine dans les maladies du sang. Bull. Acad. med. Houmanie, PJ37, 3: 366-71.—Rose, B. Studies on blood histamine in patients with allergy; alterations in the blood histamine in patients with allergic disease. J. CUn. Invest, 1941, 20: 419-28. ----- — & Browne, J. S. L. Studies on the blood histamine in rabbits during hemorrhage, shock produced by manipulation of the intestines, and following the subcutaneous injection of hista- mine. Am. J. Path, 1941, 17: 006.—Tinel, J, Ungar. G... A Parrot, J. L. Sur l'histamin6mie plasmaticne et globulaire; son evolution au cours du choc peptonique du chien. (.'. rend. Soc. biol, 1938, 129: 267-70—Ungar, G, & Ungar, A. Mise en liberty d'histamine par l'embolie pulmonaire et intestinale. Ibid, 1939, 130: 1446-8.—Went, F., & Rex-Kiss, B. [Blood histamine in abnormal hematogram and abnormal blood pres- sure] Orvostud. kozl, 1941, 2: 84-7. ---- Cardio-vascular effect. Arriagada Seguel, P. *Estudio de la acci6n dc la histamina sobre la presion arterial [Chile] 66p. 26cm. Nunoa, 1938. Gelhaar, E. *Die Wirkung des Histamina auf den venosen Ruckfluss [Frankfurt a. M.j 16p. 8? Wiirzb., 1930. Loss, G. *Biologische Reaktionen bei physi- kalischer Therapie; Einwirkung von Histamin und H-Substanzen auf den Blutdruck. 36p. 8? Lpz ., 1932. Alexiu, P. Ueber die blutdrucksteigernde Wirkung des Histamins bei Katzen mit und ohne Nebennieren. Arch. exp. Path, Lpz, 1929, 145: 222-4.—Basu, N. M. On the actions of neo-stibosan, urea-stilamine, and histamine on frog's heart. Ind. J. M. Res, 1936-37, 24: 1131-5.—Burn, J. H, ehv. ei niet.allkomplcxsalze des Methyhmidazols. Biochem. Xsrhi., 1 *.<:;»>. 284: 839-42.—Barsoum, G. S, & Gaddum, .!. H. The phaimaeological estimation of adenosine and histamine in Mood. .1. Physiol, Lond, 1935, 85: 1-14.— Businco, L. Determinazione quantitativa dell'i.stamina nei liquidi e tessuti organici. Diagn. teen, lab. Nap, 1940, 11: 131-43. ------ & Giunchi, G. Osservazioni sui recenti metodi per la determinazione quantitativa dell'istamina; Baisoum e Gaddum, Code. Boll. Soc. ital. biol. sper, 1938, 13: 905 S. Code, C. F. The quantitative estimation of histamine in the blood. J. Physiol, Lond., 1937, 89: 257-68.—Gaddum, J. H. The estimation of hi-iaiuiue in blood. Proc. R. Soc. M, Lond, 1935-36, 29: 1373-S.- Koessler. K. K, & Hanke, M. T. A quantitative method for sep-n uting histamine from histidine. J. Biol. Chem, 1919, 39: 521-38. Also repr.— Macgregor, R. G„ & Thorpe, W. V. The quantitative extrac- tion of histamine from tissues bv electrodialysis. Biochem. J, Lond, 1933, 27: 1394-9.—Minard, D. An electrodialytic method foi the quantitative extraction of histamine from small quantities of blood and plasma. Am. J. Physiol, 1940, 129: 124 Parrot. J. L. Le dosage biologique de l'histamine en elinique humaine. Progr. mid., Par, 1938, 975. ----— L'6quivalent histaminique des milieux organiques; sa mesure par un test biologique. In Intoxic. & carences aliment. (M. Loeper) Par, 1938, iGO-8.—Robillard, E. Dosages biologiques d'histamine et de folliculine. J. Hotel-Dieu Montreal, 1940, 9: 13-22.—Schwartz, A, & Riegert, A. Un proc6d6 simple d'isolcment quantitatil de l'histamine et de la tyramine dans le .serum (et le plasma) sanguin. C. rend. Soc. biol, 1936, 123: 219-23. ------ Le dosage de traces d'histamine dans le sang par le proc6d6 de la permutite; simplification de la tech- nique primitive. Ibid, 801-4.—Ungar, G. Demonstration de la mise en liberty de substances histaminiques; transmission neuro-humorale histaminergique. J. physiol. path, gin., 19.30, 34: 77-91.—Yokayama, R. Ueber die mikrokolorimetrische Bestimmung des Histamins. Jap. J. M. Sc, 1936, 4: proc. Int. Med, 208-10.—Zimmermann, W. Ueber eine spezifische Fai ben reaktion fiir Histamin. Zschr. physiol. Chem, 1929-30, 186: 260-2. ---- Elimination. Ackermann, D, & Fuchs, H. G. Zur Frage des Vorkom- mens vim Histamin im normalen Ham. Zschr. physiol. Chem, 1939, 259: 32-4.—Nisimura, T, & Tati, K. Isolierungs- versuehe des Histamins und der histaminahnlichen Substanzen von Stuhl und Ham der Ekin-kranke. Acta paediat. jap, 1939, 45: 77 (.Abstr.) — Lngar, G, & Pocoule, A. Sur les voies d'£limination de l'histamine et son absence dans les urines normales. C. rend. Soc. biol, 1937, 124: 1204-6. ---- Formation [and liberation] Heise, R. *Histaminbildung durch tierisches Gewebe [Greifswald] 16p. 21cm. Lengerich i. W.. 1937. Minard, D. *Studies on the concentration ;uid liberation of histamine in tissues. 40p. 24cm. Chic, 1939. Alechinsky, A. Sur la nature histaminique de la substance liberee dans la peau sous l'influence d'agents physiques. C. rend. Soc. biol, 1933, 113: 899.—Anrep, G. V, & Barsoum, G. S. Appearance of histamine in the venous blood during muscu- lar contraction. J. Physiol, Lond, 1935, 85: 409-20.— Bartosch, R. Ueber die Freisetzung von Histamin durch che- misch bekannte Substanzen. Arch. exp. Path, Berl, 1936, 181: 176. ------ [Origin of histamin in the animal organism; histidin-decarboxylation of animal tissue and methods in determining histamin] J. Phvsiol. USSR, 1939, 27: 043; 1940 29: 96-114.—Bourdillon, K. B, Gaddum, J. H, & Jenkins, It! G. C. The production of histamine from histidine by ultra- violet light and the absorption spectra of these substances Proc. R. Soc, Lond, 1930, ser. B, 106: 388-98.—Ellinger, F. Ueber die Entstehung eines den Blutdruck senkenden und den Darm erregenden Stoffes aus Histidin durch Ultraviolett- strahlung. Arch. exp. Path, Lpz, 1928, 136: 129-57 — Feldberg, W, & Kellaway, C. H. The liberation of histamine bv staph\ loeoeoa! toxin and mercuric chloride. Austral .1 Lxp. Biol, 193N, 16: 249 59.—Feldberg, W, & O'Connor, w! J. The liberation of histamine from tba perfused |Unr l)v peptone. J. Physiol, Lond, 1937, 90: 2S8 95. Ilaiulovsky, H. Correlation between movements of mavid litems and for- mation of histamine. I'roc. Soc. Exp. Biol, N. Y, I9:i!l, 42: 643-5.---Heubner, W, A Bachmann, IL Leber die l'roisetzung von llistanun dutch Quecksilber. Klin. Wschr, 1937, 16: 279.—Hirai, K. Ueber die Bildung von Histamin aus I- Histidin durch Bakterien. Biochem. Zschr, 1933, 267: 1-5.— Holland, G, & Srhultes, H. Ueber die Erzeugung von llista- minquaddeln durch I Ittaschall. Zschr. ges. exp. Med, 1936 98: 207-9.—Holtz, P. Die Entstehung von Histamin aus Histidin durch Besttahlumr. Arch. exp. Path, Berl, 1931, 175: 97-103. ------ Oxydo-reduktionskatalytiM he Entste- hung von Histamin aus Histidin. Ibid, 1937, 137: 589-93. ------Ueber die Entstehung von Histamin und 'I vramin im Organismus. Klin. Wschr, 1937, 16: 1501 7. ' -- & Heise, R. Leber die Entstehung von Histamin aus Ilisiidin durch Aseorbinsuure und Sulfhydrylkorper. Arch. exp. I'aih Lpz, 1937, 186: 269-80. ------ Ueber Histaminbildung inl Organismus. Ibid, 377-86.—Katz, G. The role of blood cells in the anaphylactic histamine release. J. Pharm. Exp. Ther 1941, 72: 22.—Kellaway, C. H, & Trethewie, E. R. Photo- dynamic action and the liberation of histamine. Austral. J. Exp. Biol, 1939, 17: 61-76.------& Holden, H. 1". Tissue injury by radiant energy and the liberation of histamine. Ibid, 1938, 16: 331-42.—Koessler, K. K, & Hanke, M. T. The production of histamine from histidine by Bacillus coli communis. J. Biol. Chem, 1919, 39: 539-84. Also repr.— Levy-Bruhl & Ungar, G. Production de substances hista- miniques par les bacilles muqueux en milieu synth6tique con- tenant de l'urfee comme seul aliment azot6. Ann. Inst. Pasteur, Par, 1938, 61: 828.—Macgregor, R. G, & Peat, S. An investi- gation into a possible nervous mechanism involved in the libera- tion of histamine. J. Physiol, Lond, 1931, 71: 31-5.— Marcou, I. La production cardiaque d'hislamine sous la d6pendance du travail du coeur. C. rend. Soe. biol, 1939, 130: 575-7.-—Ramirez de Arellano, M, Lawton, A. H, & Dragstedt, C. A. Liberation of histamine by trypsin. I'roc. Soc. Exp. Biol, N. Y, 1940, 43: 300.—Trethewie, E. R. Experiments on the problem of free and bound histamine and acetylcholine. Austral. J. Exp. Biol, 1938, 16: 225-32.—Ungar, G, C'ontiades, X. J, & Grossiord, A. Liberation de substances histaminiqueH par excitation du bout p6riph6rique du nerf splanchiiique; 16sions hdmorragiques de 1'intestin par injection intni-artcricllc d'histamine. C. rend. Soc. biol, 1935, 120: 328--30.—-Ungar, G, Zerling, M. R, & Pocoule, A. Sur la nature histaminique de la substance Iib6r6e par l'excitation antidromique des nerfs- sensitifs. Ibid, 118: 778.—Werle, E. Ueber die Bildung von Histamin aus Histidin durch tierisches Gewebe; vorlaufige Mitteilung. Biochem. Zschr, 1936, 288: 292. ----- & Herrmann, H. Ueber die Bildung von Histamin aus Histidin durch tierisches Gewebe. Ibid, 1937, 291: 105-21.—Werle, E., & Krautzun, K. Ueber die Bildung von Histamin aus Histidin durch tierische Gewebe. Ibid, 1938, 296: 315-24.—Zipf, K., & Gebauer, A. Ueber die Entstehung von Histamin aus Histidin durch tierisches Gewebe. Arch. exp. Path, Lpz.. 1937. 187: 501-5. ---- Gastro-intestinal effect. Branisteanu, D, & Nicolesco, I. Sur Taction cholccyslo- cinetique de l'histamine. Bull. Acad. med. Roumanie, 193'), 4: 319-24.—Edlbacher, S, Jucker, P, & Baur, H. Die Be- einflussung der Darmreaktion des Histamins durch Amino- sauren. Zschr. physiol. Chem, 1937, 247: 63.—Fonseca, F, . H, & loone. 4'. H. Effect of histamine on the parenteial denaturizaiion of foreign piote-in. J. Immun, Ball, 19L>7. 14: 341-6.— .Martin, L, & Morgenstern, M. Carbon dioxide changfs in alveolar air and I lood plasma or serum after sub- cutaneous histamine injection in human beings. J. Lab. Clin. M, 1932, IV: 1228.—Matsueda, A. 1 listopathologische Stu- dien zur Pathogenese der Hyperglykamie dutch this in die Cisterna cerebellomedullaris eingefuhrte Histamin. Okavama igakkai zasshi, 1933, 45: 1901.—Menten, M. L, & Kruj/h, H. M. Changes in blood dextrose in rabbits after intravenous injections of histamine. J. Infect. Dis, 1928, 43: 117-20.— Ohmi, F. A note on glvcaemic action of histamine in rabbils. Tohoku J. Exp. M, 1933, 21: 314-22.—Ralllin. R, it Sarad- jichvili. P. Histamine et alcalose. C. rend. Soc. biol, 1929, 102: 559.—Soula, C, Goebcl [et al.] Histamine, secretion gastrique et glycSmie. Ibid, 1932, 111: 282.—Tang, C. Einfluss des Histamins auf die arterielle Sauerstoffbindungs- kurve und auf den arteriellen Sauerstoffdruck (ein Beitrag zur Histamin wirkung auf die I.ungengcfasse) Arch. exp. Path, Berl, 19:!2, 1CX: 274-si;.--Tamil, H, & Recht, I. [Effect of histamine on the cholc-pao! in the blood of norma! and splenec- tomized dogs] .Magy. oiv. aieh.. 1929, 30: 146-9. Also Bio- chem. Zschr, 1928. 200: 190-3-Tizzano, A. Ueber die Wirkung von Histamin bei passiver Hyperthermic (Verlauf der Tempeiaturkiirve, Glykamie, Veranderungen im Wasser- und Salzgehalt) Zschr. Biol, 1938-39, 99: 1-16. ---- Metabolism. Albi, R. W., & Boyd, T. E. Absorption of histamine from the intestine of the paraihvroidectomized dog. I'roc. Soc. Exp. Biol, N. Y, 1928-29, 26: 768.------Effect of rectally administered ether-oil mixtures on absorption of histamine from the colon. Ibid, 1930-31, 28: 308.—Dragstedt, C. A, Arellano, M. R. de, & Lawton, A. II. Peptone shock in fetal dogs and its significance in the metabolism of histamine. Ibid, 191(1. 43: 28. Gebaiier-Fuclnegg, E, & Alt, H. I, Manometric .-Indies on the bio-oxidation of histamine. Ib'd, 19112, 29: 531 3. .liirnecke, H. Leber den Ilistamin-IIisti- dinstoITwechsel und seine Beeinflussung. Arch. Derm. Svph, Berl., 1938, 177: 151-1. Koessler. K. K, .v Hanke, M. T. The intestinal absorption and detoxication of histamine in the mammalian organism. J. Biol. Chem, 1924-25, 59: 889-903.— Mammoser, L. F„ & Boyd, T. E. Influence of various chemical agents on the absorption of histamine from the intestine Proc. Soe. L\p. Biol.. X. Y„ 1928-29. 26: 705, pl.—Rose, B, Zur Technik und Indikationsstellung der Histamin-Iontophorese. Deut. med Wschr, 1933, 59: 326.— Edstrom, G. [Histamin-iontophorcsisj Sven. liik. tidn, 1933, 30: 697-702.—Falk, E. Ueber Histauiin- Jontophorese. Med. Welt, 1933, 7: 998—Jankowiak, J. [Therapy with histamin iontophoresis] Nowiny lek, 1936, 48: 184-6.—Joly, M. Ionisation k l'histamine. Bull. Soc. m6d. Paris, 1938, 549-56.—Kling. D. H. Histamine cataphoresis in rheumatic conditions and in disturbances of the peripheral circulation. Med. Rec, N. Y, 1940, 152: 388-91.—Levai, M. [Mechanism of action of histaminiontophoresis] Orvoskepzes, 1934, 24: dec. kulonf. (Apponyi Festschr.) 127-31.----- [Electricity in histamin iontophoresis] Orv. hetil, 1934, 78: 428—Ota, T. The histamin-iontophoresia. Jap. J. M Sc. 1934-36, 4: Surg. &x„ 180.—Plenczner, S. Illistamin-ionto- phoresisj Budapefti orv. ujs, 1934, 32: 1037-40.—Potter, 1). Histamine ionisat'on therapy. J. State M, Lond, 1935, 43: 729-37.—Rumbaugh, U. D. Histamine iontophoresis. Med Rec, N. Y, 1937, 145: 471; 1940, 152: 222— Teschler, I, Zur Technik der Histaminiontophorese. Klin. Wschr, 1936, 15: 1445.—Vas, S. Erfahrungen mit der kataphoretischen Histaminbehandlung und neue Gesichtspunkte ihrer Anwen- dung. Deut. med. Wrschr, 1932, 58: 1009-12. ---- Tolerance. BUchler, P., & Sarudy, E. von. Ueber die Histaminempfind- hchkeit der Paralytiker. Arch. Psychiat, Berl, 1936-37, 106: 461-71.— Essex, H. E, & Horton, B. T. Observations on development of resistance to histamine in the guinea-pig. Proc. Mayo Clin, 1941, 17: 603-7.—Hirano. T. Non-impor- tance of medulla in the susceptibility to histamine of supra- renalectomized rabbits. Tohoku J. Exp. M, 1939-40, 37: 322 34.—Karady, E. S. Histamine tolerance and anaphylactic death in sensitized guinea-pigs. J. Immun, Bait, 1941, 41: 1-13.—Karady, I. [Histamine sensibility] Orv. hetil, 1933, 77: 484-8. Also Wien. klin. Wschr, 1934, 47: 622-5. ----- Experiments on the sensitiveness of animals to histamine. Magy. orv. arch, 1935, 36: 244-50. Also Arch. exp. Path, Berl, 1935-36, 180: 283-7. ------ & Bentsath, A. Hista- mingewohnung und experimentelle Anaphylaxie. Zschr. ges. exp Med, 1936-37, 100: 48-53.— Miyamoto, K. Tolerance to histamine and anaphylactic reactions. Jap. J. M. Sc, 1939-40, 3: Proc. Soc. Med. Hyg, 161.—Perla, D. Effect of splenectomy on natural resistance of albino rats and mice to histamine poisoning. Proc. Soc. Exp. Biol, N. Y, 1934, 31: 9^2.------ Effect of suprarenal cortical hormone on the natural resistance of pituitarectomized rats. Ibid, 1934-35, 32: 797-800. ■------Effect of anterior hypophysis emulsion pn natural resistance of hypophysectomized and normal rats to histamine poisoning. Ibid, 1935-36, 33: 121-4. ----- Effect of ascorbic acid on resistance of suprarenalectomized rats to histamine. Ibid, 1936-37, 35: 390. ------ & Rosen, s- H- The effect of pituitarectomy on the natural resistance of adult albino rats to histamine poisoning. Am. J. Path, 1935, 11: 890. ------ Effect of hypophysectomy on natural resistance of adult albino rats to histamine poKonim: Arch. Path, Chic, 1935, 20: 222-32.—Perla, I), & Sandboy, M. Effect of electrolyte disturbance on resistance to histamine poisoning in rats. Proc. Soc. Exp. Biol, N. Y 1939 41: 275-7. Also Arch. Path, Chic, 1939, 28: 765.—Seegal, B. C. Anaphylactic shock and susceptibility to histamine poisoning in the cotton rat, Sigmodoa hispidus littoralis. Proc. Soc. Exp. HISTAMINE 719 HISTIDINE. Biol, N. Y, 1940, 44: 628-31— Spinelli. A. Sulla aumentata resistenza della cavia puerpera alio shock da istamina. Riv. pat. sper, 1930-31, 6: 72-83.—Takatu, T. Ueber den Einfluss enteral und parenteral zugefiihrten Histamines auf die Emp- findlichkeit des Kaninchens in verschiedenen Altersstufen. Acta paediat. jap, 1939, 45: 40 (Abstr.)—Wells. J. A, Gray, J. S, & Dragstedt, C. A. An investigation of the question of histamine tolerance. J. Allergy, 1941-42, 13: 77-S-l. .---- Tolerance: Diagnostic tests. Boismoreau, P. A. *La reaction de Lewis et son facteur thermique. 68p. 24cm. Par., 1939. Bouttier, L. *Sur quelques effets physio- logiques de l'histamine; leur application a l'etude de la secretion gastrique. 112p. 8? Par., 1925. Berri, P. Ergotamina e istamina. Gazz. internaz. med. chir, 1927, 32: 427-35.------& Weinberger, M. Ulteriore contributo clinico sulla prova dell'istamina. Minerva med. Tor, 1928, 8: pt 2, 530-40.—Botkine, C. Emploi de l'hista- mine dans le diagnostic des maladies de l'estomac. Biol. m6d, Milano, 1929, 19: 271-84.—Breitmann, M. Ueber die Adrena- lin-Histaminreaktion als funktionelle Probe bei vegetativen und endokrinen Storungen. Wien. klin. Wschr, 1937, 50: 193.—Cade, A, & Milhaud, M. L'dpreuve de l'histamine; contribution k l'etude de sa valeur diagnostique. Arch. mal. app. digest. Par, 1928, 18: 121-50— Caldwell, J. M. Hista- mine reactions in chronic infectious arthritis. Proc. Mayo Clin, 1930, 5: 26.—Chiatellino, A. Modificazioni della dermo- reazione all'istamina in individui operati di ganglionectomia. Atti Soc. med. chir. Padova, 1933, ser. 2, 11: 89-93.—Davies, D, & Vanderhoof, D. The value of histamine in the differentia- tion of true and false gastric anacidity. Virginia M. Month, 1928-29, 55: 23-6.—Destefano, J., & Lima, E. J. La prueba de la histamina en gastrologia: comunicacion previa de nuestros resultados. Rev. med. lat. amer, B. Air,_ 1928, 14: 173-7.— Ferrari, G. Su alcune applicazioni cliniche della reazione ponfoide da istamina. Boll. Soc. med. chir, Pavia, 1933, 47: 339-54.—Germain, A. L'6preuve de l'histamine en clinique gastrologique. Arch. mid. pharm. nav, 1929, 118: 505-29.— Goinard, P. Les injections intra-dermiques d'histamine; procede d'exploration de la circulation tejrunlentaire en chi- rurgie des membres. BuU. med. Par, 1938, 52: 128-30.— Jausion, Giard & Bousson. L'intradermo-reaction a l'hista- mine chez les exos£reux et chez les pigmentes ethniques. Bull. Soc. fr. derm, syph, 1937, 44: 698-705.—Madariaga, O, & Madariaga, H. La histamina y su valor diagnostico. Vida nueva, Habana, 1927, 20: 179-84.—Marmorston-Gottesman, J, & Gottesman, J. The use of histamine as a standard test for diminished resistance in suprarenalectomized rats. J. Exp. M, 1928, 47: 503-14.—Morisi, G. II normal test ista- minico nei vecchi. Osp. maggiore, Milano, 1935, 23: 13-6.— Oerliis, E, & Szappanos, M. [Determination of tendency to collapse with histamin test, and importance of local anesthesia in prevention of collapse] Orvosk6pz6s, 1935, 25: aug. kulonf, 100-6.—Perlow, S. A painless histamine skin test: an experi- mental study. Ann. Int. M, 1933, 7: 561-5. ------ The temperature of the flare as an index of the intensity of the histamine skin reaction. Am. Heart J, 1936, 11: 605-10.— Pierini, L. E. Reacciones cutaneas de la histamina en derma- tosis diversas. Sem. med, B. Air, 1931, 38: 1159-70.— Rosenbusch, J. [Pathergometric investigations -with the aid of the histamine vesicle] Pedjat. polska, 1935, 15: 441.— Tzanck, A, Sidi, E, & Dobkevitch. Contribution k l'etude des tests d'intolerance; presentation de cas en apparence para- doxaux. Bull. Soc. fr. derm, syph, 1938, 45: 400.----— Reactivation d'un test d'intolerance negatif par une injection d'histamine. Ibid, 401-3. ------ Histamine et tests. Ibid, 1939, 46: 879-82. HISTIDASE. See also Histidine, Chemistry. Oppenheimer, C. Histidase. In Fermente (Oppenheimer, C.) 1936, Suppl, 1: 580-3.—Sera. Y. [Studien uber sogenannte Histidase von S. Edlbacher] Mitt, Med. Ges. Osaka, 1941 40: 730-43 _Werle, E, & Heitzer, K. Zur Kenntnis der Histi- dincarboxylase. Biochem. Zschr, 1938, 299: 420-36. HISTIDINE. See also Amino acids; Carnosine; Deficiency disease; Ergot, Chemistry; Glutamic acid; Imidazol; Protid, Hydrolysis. • Dello Iojo, G. L'istidina; chimica, metabolismo, applica- zioni terapeutiche e diagnostiche (istidino-reazione) Gior. chn. med, 1936, 17: 232-68.—Ellinger, F. Das Absorptions- spektrum von Histidin und Histamin im Ultraviolett. Biochem Zschr, 1929, 215: 279-85.—Gilson, L. E. A simplified method of preparing histidine. J. Biol. Chem 1938, 124: 2S1-0. Also repr.—Guggenheim, M. Histidin, Carnosin, Anserin und Imidazolcarbonsiiuren. In his Biogen. Amine, Basel, 1940, 338-59—Levent, R. L'histidine. Gaz. hop, 193o, 108. 1335-8.—Schwartz, A, Israel, L., & Jacob, A. Sur le mode d'action de preparation commerciales d histidine. G. rena. Soc. biol. 1935, 120: 124-6. ---- Chemistry. See also Histamine, Formation. Ackermann, D, & Mohr, M. Praparative Sicherstellung des Vorkommens von Histamin im normalen Saugetierkorper. Zschr. physiol. Chem, 1938, 255: 75-81.—Barger, G, & Ewins, A. J. The identity of trimethylhistidine (histidine- betame) from various sources. Biochem. J, Lond, 1912-13, 7: 204-6.—Becker, J. P. Spektralanalytische Untersuchungen iiber die photochemischen Veranderungen von Histidin und Histamin. Arch. ges. Physiol, 1931, 228: 751-4.—Bergmann, M., & Zervas, L. Ueber Umlagerung peptidahnlicher Stotfe; zur Kenntnis des Histidins; Peptidbildung durch Acvlwande- rung. Zschr. physiol. Chem, 1928, 175: 145-53.—Boone, G.J. The place of histidine in the protein molecule. Med. Bull. Univ. Cincinnati, 1931, 6: 193-205.—Demjanowski, S. Ueber die Gewinnung des Histidins aus dem Blute. Zschr. physiol. Chem, 1922, 122: 93-7.—Diemair, W, & Fox, H. Unter- suchungen uber die Vorgange bei der Kuppelung des Histidins und Histamins mit Diazoniumsalzen. Biochem. Zschr, 1938, 298: 38-50.—Duschinsky, R. Le dfidoublement spontanS du monochlorhydrate d'histidine racemique. In Festschrift E. C. Barell, Basel, 1936, 375-93.—Du Vigneaud, V, & Behrens, O. K. A method for protecting the imidazole ring of histidine during certain reactions and its application to the preparation of 1-amino-N-methylhistidine. J. Biol. Chem, 1937, 117: 27-36. Also repr.—Edlbacher, S, & Segesser, A. von. Der Abbau des Histidins und anderer Imidazole durch Ascorbin- saure. Biochem. Zschr, 1937, 290: 370-7.—Ellinger, F. Wei- tere Untersuchungen iiber die Entstehung eines histamin- ahnlichen Korpers aus Histidin unter Ultraviolettbestrahlung. Arch. exp. Path, Lpz, 1930, 153: 120-7. Also Strahlenthera- pie, 1930, 38: 521-42. ------ Ueber die Entstehung eines Korpers mit histaminahnlichen Wirkungen aus Histidin durch Kathodenstrahlen. Arch. exp. Path, Berl, 1931. 161: 703- 12.—Girsavicius, J. O, & Ryzhowa, A. P. Zur Antiglyoxalase- wirkung des Histidins. Biochem. Zschr, 1935, 278: 252-6.— Greenstein, J. P, & Klemperer, F. W. Aspartylhistidine. J. Biol. Chem, 1939, 128: 245-50—Harington, C. R, & Overhoff, J. A new synthesis of 2-thiolhistidine together with experiments towards the synthesis of ergothioneine. Biochem. J, Lond, 1933, 27: 338-44.—Hill, T. L, & Branch, G. E. K. Resonance and the chemistry of histidine. Science, 1940, 91: 146.—Holtz, P. Ueber den Mechanismus des Histidinabbaus durch Ascorbinsaure und Thioglykolsaure. Zschr. phvsiol. Chem, 1937, 250: 87-103. ------& Triem, G. Histidinabbau durch Ascorbinsaure und Thioglykolsaure. Ibid, 248: 5-20.— Kapfhammer, J, & Sporer, H. Eine neue Darstellung des 1-Histidin aus Eiweiss. Ibid, 1928, 173: 245-9.—Kauffmann, F, & Mislowitzer, E. Ueber den fermentativen Abbau des Histidins. Biochem. Zschr, 1930, 226: 325-37—Langenbeck, W, & Hutschenreuter, R. Der Abbau des Histidins zum y-Oxy-ornithin. Zschr. physiol. Chem, 1929, 182: 305-10.— Levy, M. The behavior of histidine in the formol titration. Proc. Am. Soc. Biol. Chem, 1932-34, 8: p. Ii.—Mertz, E. T. Cleavage of the imidazole rina; of histidine and carnosine by bromine. Proc. Soc. Exp. Biol, N. Y, 1941, 47: 312-5.— Mislowitzer, E, & Kauffmann, F. Ueber den fermentativen Abbau des Histidins. Biochem. Zschr, 1931, 234: 101-6.— Sakisaka, S. Studies on the fermentative decomposition of histidine. Fukuoka acta med, 1934, 27: 40.—Tazawa. Y. Ueber die Aufsnaltung des 1-Histidinanhydrids durch Pepsin. Enzymologia, Haag, 1939, 7: 321-4, pl.—Vickery, H. B. A useful compound of histidine. J. Biol. Chem, 1926-27, 71: 303-7. ------ The preparation of histidine by means of 3,4-dichlorobenzenesulfonic acid. Ibid, 1942, 143: 77-87. & Leavenworth, C. S. On the separation of histidine and arginine; the preparation of histidine. Ibid, 1928, 78: 627-35. ---- Detection, and estimation. See also Pregnancy, Diagnosis. Abderhalden, E. Weitere Beobachtungen fiber die Ein- wirkung von Ascorbinsaure (Vitamin C) auf Aminosauren; ein neuer Nachweis von Histidin. Fermentforschung, 1936-37, 15: 285; 360.—Asitaka, Y. Histidin-Reaktion Kapeller-Adler's und ihre klinisch-diagnostische Verwertung; ein Beitrag zur stufenphotometrischen Bestimmung des Harnhistidins. Nip- pon fujinkagakkai zasshi, 1935, 30: 22-4.—Barac, G. La diazoreaction de l'histidine. C. rend. Soc. biol, 1935, 118: 198-200.—Block, R. J. The estimation of histidine. Proc. Soc. Exp. Biol, N. Y, 1937-38, 37: 580-2. Also J. Biol. Chem, 1940, 133: 67-9. Also repr.—Dello Iojo, G. Un nuovo metodo per la determinazione quantitativa dell'istidina nell'uri- na. Diagn. teen, lab. Nap, 1936, 7: 346-55.—Jorpes, E. The colorimetric determination of histidine. Biochem. J, Lond, 1932, 26: 1507-11.—Kapeller-Adler, R. Ueber eine neue Methode zur quantitativen Histidinbestimmung und iiber deren Anwendbarkeit zur Untersuchung von biologischen Fliissigkeiten, insbesondere von Gravidenharnen. Biochem. Zschr, 1933, 264: 131-41. ------ Ueber eine stufenphoto- metris'che Bestimmung des Histidins. Ibid, 1934, 271: 206- g__Kurihara, Z. Eine Mikrobestimmungsmethode des Histi- dins. J. Biochem, Tokyo, 1939, 30: 205-16.—Lang, K. Eine Mikromethode zur Bestimmung des Histidins, insbesondere ein Verfahren zur Trennung von Histidin und Tyrosin. Zschr. physiol. Chem, 1933, 222: 3-5.—Meshkova, N. P. [Methods in colorimetric determination of histidin and carnosin with .HISTIDINE 720 HISTIDINE bromide] J. Physiol. USSR. 1930, 20: lir.tO 9. Niendorf, F. Quantitative Bestimmung von Histidin im Hun. Zschr, physiol. Chem, 1939, 259: 194-200.- Rarker. K. Histidin, detection and estimation in urine. Biochem. .1, Lond, 1940, 31: stM)6.- Schwartz. A. Nouvel argument en faveur de ['attribution n l'histidine de la diiizorcaction du sfrum sanguin. ('. rend. Soe. biol, 1939, 131: 519-22. Woollcy. I). W, & I'eterson, W. H. Some observations on the Kapoller-Adler method for the determination of histidine; the histidine content of yeast. J. Biol. Chem, 1937-38, 122: 207-11. Also repr. ---- Excretion. Kullak, E. [A. E.] *Zur Frage der histi- dinausscheidung in der Graviditat [Berlin] 19p. 23cm. Charlottenb., 1937. Agnoli, R. Ricerca della istidinuria nell'asma bronchiale e nelle flngosi acute del polmone. Gior. clin. med, 1938, 19: 169-80.—Bod6. B. [Histidine excretion in pregnants] Orv. hetil, 1934, 78: 761-3. — Foldes, F. Das Vorkommen des Histidins im menschlichen Uiiti. Biochem. Zschr, 1935-36, 283: 199-209.—Gertler, H. Lntersuchungen uber das Vor- kommen von Histidin im men-ehlichcn Harn. Endokrinologie, 1930, 17: 45 7. Kapeller-Adler, R. Bemerkung zur Arbeit Franz I oldes: Das Yoikommen des Histidins im menschlichen Urin. Biochem. Zschr, 1936, 285: 123. ------& Herrmann, H. Zur Frage der Histidinurie bei der Gravidit.it. Klin. Wschr, 1934, 13: 1220.—Kapeller-Adlor, R, & Schiller, W. Uebei die Ilistidiiinusscheidiiiig in der Schwangerschaft unter dem Kinfluss verschiedenartiger Lrn:'ihiung. Ibid, 1935, 14: 1790-2. banglcy, VV. D. Urinary histidine; determination of hi-tidine in urine; histidine in normal and in pregnancv urines. I. Mini. Chem, 19 11, 137: 255-65.—Neuweiler, W, &'Grimm, W. Histidinausseheidung im Harn. Klin. Wschr, 1940, 19: 155-7 (microfilm)-—Niendorf, F. Histidinausscheidung im normalen und pathologischen Harn. Ibid, 937-40 (microfilm)— Petrov-Maslakov, M. A. [Histid'muria in prejrnancv] Sovet. vrach, 193S. 42: 14 I 4.—Plotz, K. J. Ueber die Histidinaus- -cheidutm im Harn von Schwangeren. Zbl. Gyn, 1941, 65: 309 15. Rarker. E. Histidine in urine. Biochem. J, Lond, 1941, 35: 667 71.—Sakaguchi, R. Leber die Histidinaus- scheidung im Ham. J. I'.iochem, Tokyo, 1910. 31: 289-302.— Tschopp, W, & Tschopp, H. Untersuchungen iiber die Histi- dinausscheidung im Harn. Biochem. Zschr, 1938, 298: 200-26, ---- Metabolism. Zeyen, M. *Das Verhalten dor Ameisen- stiure im Harn nach Zufuhr von Histidin [Berlin] p. 128-40. 8? Charlottenb., 1932. Also Zschr. klin. Med, 1932, 120: Abderhalden, V... & Buadze. S. Weitere Studien iiber das Schicksal des Histidins im tierischen Organismus. Zschr. ph\-iol. Chem, 1931, 200: 87-100.--Conrad, R. M, & Berg, ('. I\ The optical inversion of d-hi-tidine in the animal body. J. Biol. Chem, 1937, 117: 351-63. Also repr.--Da Cruz, A. Sur la degradation biochimiiiue de l'histidine; contribution au probleme de l'existence d'amtnoniaeases. C. rend. Soc. biol, 1937, 126: 590-2.- Doty. J. R, A- Eaton, A. G. Metabolism of the basic amino acids; rates of absorption in rats of the mono- hydrochlorides of d-lvsine and l-histidine. J. Biol. Chem 1937-38, 122: 139-46. Also repr.—Eaton, A. G, & Doty, J. R. The heat production and blood and urine constituents after administration of l-histidine to the dog. Am. J. Physiol, 1940 129: 350. Adso J. Nutrit, 1941, 21: 25-34.—Edlbacher, S.', Kraus. J, & Neber, M. Zur Kenntnis des intetmediaren Stoli'weehsels di's Histidins. Zschr. physiol. Chem, 1926, 157: 11)6; 1931). 191: 225; 1931. 195: 267; 1934, 224: 261.—Harrow, B, ! 4: S9-I0P. Hosoda. T. Ueber die ph\ siologische Wiikung des llistidinanli\ dtids und des Histidyl histidin-esters. Biochem Zschr, 1926. 167: 221-0.—Kohl. II. Ueber die gerinnunes^ fordernde Wiikung des Histidins. Klin. Wschr, 1936, 15: 1847.—Loeper, M, Perreau, P, & Rov. I, L'iiitradermorcac tion k l'histidine. C. rend. Soc biol, 1936, 121: 1021-3.— Mackay, M. The effect of histidine on the histamine content of the lungs and on histamine reactions. Austral. .1. Kxp. Biol 1938, 16: 137-42.—Miyake, S. Pharmakologische Studieil iiber die Wirkung der Methylaniinooctens; Wirkung auf die Blutgefiisse, Atmung, Harnabsonderung und den Blutzucker und Einfluss des Histidinum hydrochloricum auf die Wirkung der genannten Substanz auf den iiberlebenden Uterus und Darm des Kaninchens. Okayama igakkai zasshi, 1937, 49: 2057.—Parrot, .1. L. Choc anaphylactique des organes Isolds; absence de variation dans le pouvoir dficarboxylant du rein de cobaye k regard de l'histidine. C. rend. Soc. biol, 1939, 130: 334-0.—Puccinclli, V. Azione degli aminoacidi sui pro- cessi rigenerativi; influenza dell'istidina. Clin, chir, Milano, 1937, 40: 651-7.—Recent advances in therapeutics; histidine hydrochloride. Pharm. J, Lond, 1936, 4. ser, 83: 153.— Sandweiss, D. J, Saltzstein, H. C, & Glazer, W. S. The value of histidine in prevention of experimental ulcer in dogs. Am J. Digest. Dis, 1937-38, 4: 20-3.—Untersteiner-Occhialini. I, Ricerche farmacologiche sulla monoiodoistidina con particolare riguardo alia eliminazione renale nei coniglio. Biochim. ter. sper, 1940, 27: 77-81. ----— Ricerche farmacologiche sulla monobromoistidina con particolare riguardo all'eliminazione renale. Ibid, 187-95.—Vartiainen, A, & Koski. T. Sind Histidininjcktioncu imstande, die Entstehung des experi- mentellen llistaminulkus beim Meerschweinchen zu verhindern? Acta Soc. med. Duodecim, ser. A, 1940, 22: 1-12. HISTIOCEPHALUS. See Spiruroidea. HISTIOSTRONGYLUS. See Trichostrongylinae. HISTOCHEMISTRY. See also Biochemistry; Cell; Microchemistry; Spectrography; Staining; Tissue. Chamot, E. M., & Mason, C. W. Handbook of chemical microscopy, v.l. 474p. .8? N. Y., 1930. Henckel, K. O. Die Mikroveraschung (Veraschung mikroskopischer Schnitte) p. 1471- 7. 4? Berl., 1932. Klein, G. . Praktikum der Histochcmie. 70 [2]p. 8? Wien, 1929. Lison, L. Histochimie animale; methodes et problemes. 320p. 8? Par., 1936. Policard, A., & Okkels, H. Die Mikro- veraschung (Mikrospodographie) als histoche- mische Hilfsmethode. p.1815-28. 4? Berl.. 1932. Angelini, G. 11 metodo del microincencrimento per lo studio di sostanze inorganiche nei tessuti (studio sintetico- critico e contributo metodologico) Monit. zool. ital, 1932, 42: 319-35.—Antonow, A. Eine einfache Methode fur histo- logischen Kalknachweis. Zschr. wiss. Mikr, 1926, 43: 243-5.— Behrens, M. Mechanische Isolierung von Zell- und Gewebe- bestandteilen in grcisseren Mengen. Ber. Phys. med. Ges. Wurzburg (1938) 1939, n. F, 62: 71-1—Blanchetiere, A, & Romieu, M. La reaction histochimique de Romieu pour les substances prot&ques, ses conditions d'obtcntion, son mecan- isme et sa signification. C. rend. Soc. biol, 1931, 107: 1127-9.— Dolejsek, V, & Gawalowski, K. [Measuring absorption in the millimetric layers of tissue] Cas. lek. Cesk, 1926, 65: 1253-4.— Freudenberg. E. Bemerkungen zur Rablschen Methode des histologischen Kalknachweises. Klin. Wschr, 1926,5:64-6.— Gersh, I. Recent developments in hi-toc heini-i i-v. Physiol. Rev, 1941, 21: 242-66.—Gilding, H. 1\ Tin- relative reaction within living mammalian tissues; the fixation for histological purposes of erythrolitmin after vital staining, with a note on the distribution of the indicator. J. Exp. M, 1930, 52: 949- 52. Also repr.—Hollande, A. C. L'insolubilisation des urates figures dans les coupes histologiques. Bull. hist, appl. Par, 1931, 8: 170-8.—Jacobi, W, & Keuscher, W. Ueber den mikrochemischen Kalium- und Calcium-nachweis im histo- logischen Schnitt. Arch. Psychiat, Berl, 1926-27, 79: 323-6.— Joseph, A. De la localisation histologique de quelques sub- stances medicamenteuses par leur fluorescence en lumiere de HISTOCHEMISTRY 721 HISTOCYTE Wood. Bull. Soc. sc. mdd. biol. Montpellier, 1925-26, 7: 450.—Kreidl, A, & Nirenstein, E. Ueber die Differenzierung der einzelnen Gewebsbestandteile auf Grund ihres verschiedenen Bindungsvermogens fiir Kongorot. Arch. ges. Physiol, 1926, 212: 642-4.—Lanz, T. von. Zur elektrometrischen Messung der reellen Aziditat in Zellen und Geweben mittels einer Iridi- umwasserstoffelektrode bei schwachen mikroskopischen Ver- grosserungen. Zschr. wiss. Mikr, 1931, 48: 1-8.—Lazzarini, L. Nuovo metodo istochimico per la ricerca dei saponi degli acidi grassi nei tessuti. Diagn. teen, lab. Nap, 1931, 2: 750-2.—Leroux, R, & Craciun, E. C. Une cellule pour reac- tions histo-chimiques. C. rend. Soc. biol, 1928, 99: 1899-901 - Linderstrom-Lang, K. Problems in histochemistry. Arch. exp. Zellforsch, 1930-37, 19: 231.—Lison, L. Les methodes et les possibilitds de l'histochimie. Lidge mdd., 1935, 28: 613-38.—Niethammer, A. Bio- und Histochemie der pflanz- lichen Friichte und Samen. Biochem. Zschr, 1930, 220: 348-57.—Patrassi, G. II microincenerimento dei tessuti come mezzo d'inda^ne istobiochimica. Diagn. teen, lab. Nap, 1930, 1: 958-66.—Pfeiffer, H. Eine Methode zur kolori- metrischen Bestimmung der Wasserstofnonenkonzentration in pflanzlichen Gewebeschnitten ohne Anwendung von Modera- toren. Zschr. wiss. Mikr, 1925, 42: 3! 6-414.—Policard, A. Some new methods in histochemistry. Harvey Lect, Bait, 1931-32, 27: 204-26, 2 pl.------Technique permettant la microincineration d'une coupe sous controle microscopique continu. Bull, histol. appl, Lyon, 1936, 13: 426-30.------ Bases structurales et ultrastructurales de la microincindration; mdcanismes de formation des grains de cendre. Ibid, 1940, 17: 81-94, pl. ------& Morel, A. Application de la spectrogra- phie d'dmission aux probldmes histochimiques; l'histospectro- graphie par dtincelage direct des coupes. Ibid, 1932, 9: 57-68. Also Sunti Congr. internaz. fisiol, 1932, 14. Congr, 206. ------ Utilisation de la spectrographie de raies en histochimie (histospectrographie) C. rend. Acad, sc, 1932, 194: 491-3.—Policard, A, & Okkels, H. Localizing inorganic substances in the microscopic sections; the micro- incineration method. Anat. Rec, 1929-30, 44: 349-61 — Rohlinger, H, & Reitz, M. Die Methode der Schnittver- aschung und ihre Bedeutung fiir die plrvsikalisch-tberapeutische Forschung. Zschr. wiss. Mikr, 1939, 56: 361-7.—Rohdenburg, G. L, & Geiger, J. The distribution and amount of calcium and of potassium in normal tissue of the mouse; a histo- chemical study. Arch. Path, Chic, 1928, 6: 215-27 — Rokay, G. Z. Jodreaktion der Blutplattchen, Spindelzellen und Knochenmarksgebilde. Klin. Wschr, 1926, 5: 63.— Schultz-Brauns, O. Histo-topochemische Untersuchungen an krankhaft veranderten Organen unter Anwendung der Schnitt- veraschung. Virchows Arch, 1929, 273: 1-50. ------ Ueber den Ausbau der Technik der Schnittveraschung und uber neue histo-topochemische Aschenbefunde. Verh. Deut. path. Ges, 1931, 26. Kongr, 153-62 [Discussion] 171-4. ----- Die Methode der Schnittveraschung unfixierter tierischer Gewebe. Zschr. wiss. Mikr, 1931, 48: 161-91.— Schumacher, J. Zur Chemie der Zellfarbung; Schwermetall- ionen und Zeile. Chem. Zeile, 1926, 13: 1-38. ------ Zur Technik der Gewinnung nukleinsaurefreier Zellen. Ibid, 191-209, pl. ■------ Zur Chemie der Differenzierung und uber nukleinsaures Pyronin und Pyroninnukleinsaure. Ibid, 220-46.—Scott, G. H., & Horning, E. S. Study of normal and malignant tissues bv microincineration. Proc. Soc. Exp. Biol, N. Y, 1932, 29: 708.—Shapiro, S. Histologic demon- stration of the phosphatides and cerebrosides. Arch. Path, Chic, 1927, 13: 661-4.—Turchini, J. La technique des empreintes appliqude k l'histochimie. Bull. Acad. sc. Mont- pellier, 1936, 66; 30.—Wood, E. H. A low temperature wet ashing method applied to the study of the electrolyte composi- tion of the ventricular musculature and lung parenchyma of the dog. J. Biol. Chem, 1942, 143: 165-70. HISTOCYTE. See also Connective tissue, Cytology; Histo- cytosis; Phagocyte; Reticuloendothel. Midy, R. M. Le conjonctif histiocytaire. 2. ed. 357p. 8? Par. [1936] Balduini, M. Sistema istiocitario e fenomeni immunitari. Gior. batt. immun, 1935, 15: 887-900.—Buno, W. Histio- cytes des mdninges et des plexus choroides. C. rend. Soc. biol, 1934, 117: 558-60.—Cavallaro, V. Cellule istioidi (emoistioblasti) e loro derivati granulocitici nei fegato e nella milza embrionale. Haematologica, Nap, 1924, 5: 266-70.— Clasing, C. Ueber den Abbau der Bluthistiocyten. Vir- chows Arch, 1930, 277: 143-58.—Fegler, J. [Morphology of Ferrata's cell] Opusc. clin. int. praefect. scholae san. tuendae Warsaw, 1927, 19-25.—Fischer, A. Ueber Charakter- und Spezifitatskonstanz der Gewebezellen. Arch. ges. Physiol, 1929, 223: 163-70.—Fontana, L. Sui caratteri diflerenziah tra le varie forme di istiociti del sangue. Riforma med, 1926, 42: 629.—Gabe, M. Ueber die Affinitat der Histiozyten fur die verschiedenen Organe und Gewebe; experimentelle Un- tersuchung mittels der Karminzellen-Injektion in die vordere Kammer des Auges. Tr. Jap. Path. Soc, 1930, 20: 453.— Gonzalez Guzman, I. Estudio nucleolar de algunos histiocitos de los roedores. Arch. lat. amer. card, Mdx, 1934-35, 5: 132-45.—Grossfeld, H. Methode der Permeabilitatsbestim- mung tierischer Gewebszellen. Bull, internat. Acad, polon. bc, 1937, ser. B, 2: 249-59.—Hamazaki, Y., & Gabe, M. Ueber 227475—VOL. 7, 4th series-----46 i A^lmtat der Histiozyten fur die verschiedenen Organe und Gewebe; experimentelle Untersuchungen mittels der Karminzellen-Injektion in subcutanes Bindegewebe. Tr. Jap. Path. Soc, 1930, 20: 451.—Hamazaki, Y, & Watanabe, M. Ueber die Affinitat der Histiozyten zu den verschiedenen Organen und Geweben; experimentelle Untersuchungen mittels intravaskularer Injektion von Karminzellen. Ibid, 1929 19: 212; 1930, 20: 449. Also Fol. haemat, Lpz, 1929, 39: 12-34. ------ Ueber die Affinitat der Histiozyten zu den verschie- denen Organen und Geweben; uber die Affinitat der Karmin- zellen zu den Organen und Geweben des jungen Kaninchens. Ibid, 1930-31, 43: 429-45.—Hayakawa, M. Ueber die epi- theloiden Histiozyten nach Hamazaki. Tr. Jap. Path. Soc, 1929, 19: 202-6.—Ishikawa, R. On the reticulohistiocyte system of the skin. Mitt. Med. Akad. Kioto, 1938, 24: 1159- 04.—Ito, C. Einfluss der verschiedenen Reize auf die Histio- zyten bei der Fremdkorperriesenzellenbildung. Tr. Jap. Path. Soc, 1931, 21: 315-8.—Kahn, M. C. Mobility velocities of histiocytes from normal and from sensitized guinea pigs. Proc. Soc. Exp. Bio], N. Y, 1941, 46: 635-8.—Kamiyonahara, C. Untersuchungen betr. die Bluthistiozyten mittelst der vitalen Farbung in vitro. Tr. Jap. Path. Soc, 1925, 15: 11.— Koike, T. Studien iiber die Hisfiiozyten in der Haut; iiber den Einfluss der Milzexstirpation auf die Histiozyten der Haut. Okayama igakkai zasshi, 1930, 42: 1817.—Kurokawa, T. Fiihigkeit der Gewebezellen, Zucker aufzunehmen und zu fixieren sowie ihre Beziehung zur Insulinwirkung und Zucker- krankheit. Tohoku J. Exp. M, 1926, 8: 54-75.— Lorokine, E. S. IHistocyt.es in the normal skin of a rabbit] Omsky med. J, 1928, 3: 19-25.—Laufberger, V. [Ultrastructure of tissue cells] Vrach. delo, 1937, 19: 22-4.—Mollendorff, M. von. Ueber Histiozytenbildung aus Fibrozytenreinkulturen des erwachse- nen Kaninchens nach leichten chronischen Reizungen. Zschr. Zellforsch, 1930-31, 12: 559-78.—Seki, M. Zur Kenntnis der intra- und supravitalen Farbung; elektrische Ladung der Histiocyten und Retikuloendothelien. Ibid, 1934-35, 22: 445-56.—Silberberg, M. Lymphocyten und Histiocyten. Klin. Wschr, 1930, 9: 174-6.—Tsukamoto, S. The influence of osmotic pressure of the milieu and the dehydration of tissues upon the phagocytosis and supravital staining of histiocytes in vitro. Tr. Jap.Path. Soc, 1931,21:237-43.—Uyeyonahara, A. Studies on the histiocyte of the human blood by means of vital staining in vitro. Ibid, 1928, 18: 125-30.—Uyeyonahara, T. Studies of human blood histiocytes with vital staining method in test tube. Bull. Nav. M. Ass, Tokyo, 1926, 15: No. 6. Also Fol. haemat, Lpz, 1930, 40: 1-31, pl.—Vasiliu, T. Contribution k 1'dtude des cellules migrantes primitives: hdmohistioblastes de Ferrata. Haematologica, Na,p, 1924, 5: 34—40, pl.—Watanabe, K. Ueber die Silberreaktion der histiozytaren Zellen. Tr. Jap. Path. Soc, 1930, 20: 398-400 — Watanabe, M. Ueber die epitheloiden Histiozyten (Hama- zaki) an den Cerebrospinalmeningen. Ibid, 1931, 21: 658-61. ------& Konishi, N. Ueber die Affinitat der Histiozyten zu den verschiedenen Organen und Geweben; iiber die Affinitat der Karminzellen, die in den Subarachnoidealraum oingespritzt werden, zu den Retikuloendothelialgeweben innerhalb des Aquaeductus cochleae. Ibid, 661-3.—Woodcock, H. M. Hsematophagy and haemetaboly as a normal function'of various types of tissue-cell. J. R. Army M. Corps, 1924, 43: 341; 422.—Yamamoto, T. Some comparative observations on histiocytes and melanophores in earlier stage. Tr. Jap. Path. Soc, 1930, 20: 454-7. ---- Origin. Chevremont, M. Les dldments du muscle squdlettique cultivd in vitro; leur transformation en histiocytes. C. rend. Soc. biol, 1939, 132: 487-90.—Desaive, P. A propos du role et de l'origine des histioevtes dans l'ovaire irradid de lapine adulte. Arch, biol, Lidge, 1936, 46: 385-98.—Goldner, J. Capacitds dvolutives des cellules adipeuses; expdrience de 1'dpuisement du pouvoir histiocytoformateur. C. rend. Soc. biol, 1934, 115: 72-4.—Mollendorff, von. Die Entstehung von Histiozyten in Kultnren erwachsenen Bindegewebes. Arch. exp. Zellforsch, 1931, 11: 157-61 fDiscussion] 167-9 — Schultz, A. Ueber Umformungen der Fibrozyten (Histiozyten- bildung) im menschlichen Bindegewebe. Verh. Deut. path. Ges, 1928, 23: 459-73.—Seemann, G. Ueber die Herkunft der sogenannten Polyblasten (Histiozyten, Makrophagen) Ibid, 1930, 25: 77-9.—Thomas, J. A. Essais biochimiques sur la transformation expdrimentale in vitro des cellules en histiocytes. C. rend. Acad, sc, 1935, 201: 1431-3. Also Ann. physiol. Par, 1936, 12: 13-47. Also Arch. exp. Zellforsch, 1936-37, 19: 299-324. HISTOCYTOMA. See also under parts affected. Alkiewicz, J. Sur les rapports entre l'histiocytome et le dermatofibrome de Darier-Ferrand. Rev. fr. derm, vdndr, 1939, 15: 195-210.—Becker, S. W, & Obermayer, M. E. A case for diagnosis, histiocytoma? Arch. Derm. Syph, Chic, 1940 41: 1151.—Capani, L. Su un caso di istiocitomatosi. Clin.'med. ital, 1934, 65: 225-40.—Cerruti, H, & Alayon, F. L. Considerasoes sobre os histiocitomas. An. paul. med. cir, 1941 42: 156-60.—Chatellier, L, & Gadrat, J. Histiocytome siddrosique. Bull. Soc. fr. derm, syph, 1936, 43: 771-7.— Chiodi, V. Istiocitomatosi sistematizzata iperplastico-dis- plastica neoplastiforme. Gior. clin. med, 1939, 20: 497-512.— HISTOCYTOMA 722 HISTOGENESIS Diss. A. Histioc\ tome hdmosiddrinique pscudomdlanique de la peau. Hull. Soc! fr. derm, sj ph, 1938, 45: 1903-7.— Dobke- vitch. S, ik Kerreira Marques. A propos de deux cas d'lustio- cytomcs pigmentes. Ibid, 1939, 46: 1388-91.—Dupont. A. IIistioc> tomes malins de la peau, des gaines tendineuses et de- apone\ io-cs. Bull. Ass. fr. cancer, 1939, 28: 156-72.—Kab- brani, M. Istiocitoma maligno a localizzazione ghiandolare ed intestinale. Arch. ital. anat. i«at, 1939, 10: 357-72.- Gate. J, Michel. P. J, & Freidt I. A. Un cas d'histiocvtoine. Bull. Soc fr. derm, syph, 1934. 41: 577.— Gougerot, H„ & Dreyfus. Ii. Histiocytome malm, ulcdi o-vdedtant; post-traumatique; le tiaumatisine avant fait degi'nerer un fibrome ancicn. Ibid, 1937, 44: 1699-1703. Lafftirguc, P.. it Lacoste. Un nouveau CIS d histioc\ tome noir. Algerie med., 1940, 4. s.t., 44: 114 6.- Massia. G... . Med, 1933 89: 30-4 8.—Corlini, F. Reazioni istiocitarie da sostanze di uso terapeutico. Boll. Soc. mod. chir. Modena, 1935, 35: 345-61.— Damt shek. W. The appearance of histiocytes in the peripheral blood. Arch. Int. M, 1931, 47: 968-85. Also repr.- Durante, G. Migration intra-vasculairc des cellules dites fixes de l'or- Kanisine. Sang, Par, 1929, 3: 369-97- Kfzel, K. 1 lisliocytos circulnntes nos : 150.--Limousin, H. Emploi de la drshydratation continue dans la technique liisloloo-ique C K-n.l. Soc biol., 192"), 92: 409-11.—Mariani, M. Due nuovi dispositivi di tecnica microscopica. Ann. clin. odont , Roma, 1936, 13: 111-30.- Olsen. M. W. A simple method of tians- ferring tissues. Stain Techn., 1942, 17: 73.- Reimann, S. P. The good ami bad of histological technics. Am. ,1 M Techn 19-11, 7: 34- 10.—Rotarides, M. Die technischen Yerfaluen ni der Malakcc/oologie. Zschr. wiss. Mikr.. 11128. 45: 296-355.— Sciineidau, J. I)., jr. Two time saving methods of affixin" sections to slides. Tr. Am. Micr. Soe., 1037, 56: 258.- Seki, M. Untersuchungen mit nichtwasserigen Flussigkeiten; Fixieiini" von (ieweben in nichtwiisscrigen Fliissigkciton. Zsehr Zell- for-eh., 1937,26:305-20.-------Lntersuchungen mil nicht uas-erigen Flussigkeiten; Schrumpfung von fixierten Geweben wahrend der Ueberfuhrung von Wasser bis in Paraffin. Ibid., 321-37.-- Shaw, D. L. Dioxan method for tissue preparation Am .1 M. Tcrhn 1941, 7: 258-62.-Shiga. S. Ueber die kntkalkung.-mctliode von Geweben. Verh. Jap. path. Ges., 1918, 8: 216.- .Simon, I. Ricerche istologiche su alcuni organi dl conigh trattati con iniezioni .sottocutanee di glicerina Palhologica (lenova. 1914-15, 7: 127-9.-Simonds. A. O. Iboxan dehydration for paraffin embedded Lucus slides Stain Techn., 1939, 14: 101.—Spanner, It. Die Kleis'teriniek- tion, ihre praktische Anwendung und Verbcsseruii" fiir Auf- hcllungspi tip rate. Anat. Anz., 1937-38, 85: 299-304 — Stowell, R. i: Effect on tissue volume of various methods of ^aoo'"' «;V'''■v'i''!',,""■ ,,,[| embedding. Stain Techn., 1941, 16- 67-83.—lahmisian. T. N., & siirer, E. H. Sectioning and staining ietrucloi,\ matenals in parallin. Science 1942 95- 2S4-- Thije. J. 11. ten [Frozcn-nnd paiadin-scctions] Veil' tschr. geneesk., 1939, 83: 5988.- -Verhorfr. F. H. Some im- provements in histological technique. In Contr Ophth Sc Menasha, Wis., 1926, 47 ol.- Villascnor. G. Tres tecnicas generates empleadas en el laboratorio de histologfa del Hospital Juarez. Rev. cir. Hosp. .Juarez, Mix \>KU\ 7- 363 5— \\areem. G ('. van. Die Uebertragung rinzehier Pa'ia'lnn- schmtte. /schr. «,>,. Mikr., 1927, 44: 36.- Waterman, H. G 1 rehminary notes on chronic fixation in alcoholic inediT St. ol Techn.. 1934, 9: 23-31.- Wilson. W. M. A quick, easy 'met I,',,, of preparing tissues for microscopic examination by eoi ' lehr. (Lichtwitz) 1 ----- Technic: Material. See also Olloidin; Eosin; Formaldehyde, etc Akinfiev. K jllbtolo-ical methods in preparing concentrated mediums for field lahcatories] Vest, mikrob., 1933 12- 213- /.—Baker. J. It A fluid for softening tissues embedded in parallin wax. J. IL Mn-r. Soc, Lond., 1941 61- 75-8 — Baltisberper. W. T, .< hlotc ssigsaure als Schnellentkalkun^s- und Fixierungsnuliel. Zhl. allg. Path., 1921-22, 32: 537-40 — Bonmig. U. Zur (ielatine-Einbettung. Ibid 19->7--->S 41- o—Cretin, A. Le i..placement du formol en technique histolo- gique Arch b,ol., Par. 1928, 38: 87-92.-])ie(ri<■!,. A. Iso- propylalkohol fur histologische Zwecke. Zhl -,1k p-fi. 1929-30. 47: 83.-Evans. N. Gum dammai for mounting sections Arch. Path., Chic, 1938, 25: 83.—Gheorghiu, G N Leber den Cebrau h von formol-ehromhaltijren Fixiermitteln bei z\ ulogischen Studien. Zschr. wiss. Mikr 1935-30 52- 422 4—Groat. It. A. Two new mounting media superior'to tanrula balsam and gum damar. Anat. Rec, 1939 74- 1-6 — ( lcarmg tissue Willi mixtures of tribulvl and tri-o- '■i.-s.'. 1 phosphates. Stain Techn., 1941, 16: 111-7—Gro's W A- I.ohans, H. Untersuchungen uber die W'irktin" voiY'lIar" tungslius-sigki-itet, auf lierbcho Gewebe. Zschr wjss Mi '- .931-32, 48: lbs. tab.-Hofker. J. Die Triehloic s„sai^! als I-.Merungsmit.e! 11,,,,., ,921. 38: 130-7.-Huiner S II ,,,,'i •V,1.'1':--1'" >>tyre"e m»U''tiiig medium. Stain Techn' 1941. lb: 1 , 7 - Ido-Rozas. A. Ueber e,n Ma/e, ationsmittel "iss. yiiki.. 935, 52: 1/2-4.—lngelman-Sundberg, A. Die lix.erung.vt.,hali,usse dc-s Suhlimatformalins Un I dessen -tab.h~ieM.ng t.ir langere Aufbewahrung. Ippsala lak fd4n :: ... 934, 39: 1M 202 5 pl.-I„k8ter. R. (L Theu^ of •llo.-obe lor rapio .lehydration in paraffin embedding and in the staining of sections. J. Path. Bact., Lond., 1937 44- >6<£ . J.-Jaquierl < lufluen,,; du pH dans les fixations au formol < rend. >oc. b„,I.. 1939. 10t: 483-5.-Kaneko, K. JodalkoToi als IixieiungMnitt.l bei Misslscher Farbung fur Paraffin Katch^K A",ADaV ''^ V"iv' S^dai, 1965, H 17, il£- V .£.;,, h v- H^.iel?u,ng.en zwischen der chemischen rv'tc , Tr 1J,xa,'""ffl,^s,Kk«l*oUnd der Basophilic des ''Vl,s- Tr- Jap. Path. Soc, 1931. 21: 236—Kaul N k Mukerji. B.. & Chopra. K. N. An incligenous miunOnE medium tor microscopic work. Current Sc, Han-do™ 194 g,o 4sT 8^-Kirkpatnck. J & Lendrum. A. G. Further' observation's on the use of synthetic resin as a substitute for Canada balsam precipitation of parallin wax in the medium and an mipi,,Vcd plasticiser. .1. I'ath. Pact.. Lond., 1941. 53: 111 3 Mc. Dowell, A. !\L. ,v Vjiskon. <;. A., jr. A comparison of starch paste and albumin mixture as agents for the routine mountine ol panilhn sections. Arch. Path., Chic, 1940, 29: 432-1 — Magruder, S. It. A comparative studv of dehydration I Lab. CUn. M., 1937-38, 23: 405 11—Oilman." R. K Tri- cb!oreih\ lene as a solvent in histological technic. Stain Techn 1935, 10: 23.— Potrunkevitrh. A.. : i "-2°5.-Queries. S. G. [Action of histolv.sates] Vrach' delo 1935, 18: 597 608.- Lande, V. S. Kmploi des histolvsata mi oto-lar.\ngologie. Rev. larviiu., Herd., 1935,56: 1117-25 Loiscleur, J. Azotemie et chloremie au cours de I'histohse C. rend. Soc. biol., 1935, 120: 675-8. ------- & Crovisier V bur la mise en Evidence des produits de l'histolyse au cours de a resorption dun tissu radioneerose, chez le lapin. Ibid a"/'i ,2;,= 'J^"t,~ MatLs,u^. «• Ueber die EinflOsse des Autolysates der Datmschleimhaut auf den Oiganismus Tr Soc path, jaj,., 1935. 25: 561-3.—Morgenstern, Z. I. [Morpho- logical reactions tifter injections of cortical suprarenal and Ihyroi.l histol.,.sates] Sovet. klin., 1933,, 19: i.-,6--Ol'.- Nikolaev, , i ' i '^'''"tt^ynamic properties of histoh-sates of l'rof. 1 ushnev] fr. Acad. mil. med. Kirolf, 1934, 1 : 131 17 ______ [Sjieeific action of histolysates from sexual "lands] Ibid 148- oS.-Sakharov G. P. [Pro and contra the study of specifitv of histcily^ates] Sovet. klin 1933, 19: 141 51.-' Schlachman, sri or ' v ',"' "'"■'■^'■ity of histolysates] Ter. arkh., 1935, 13: 89-96. Vyshegorodtscva, V. I). [Mechanism of phyr iologi.-al action of h,,tol\ sales| Ibid., 1937, 15: 164-75. HISTOMONAS. See also Blackhead; Turkey, Disease Babes V., & Zigura, V. Etude sur l'entero-her,atite sup- faQ^^o, r"-'-"e; ,A""' Inst" IJath- ba(l- Ibn-arest (1892/3) 1895 5: 211-0 ,, 4 pl - Patten, R. A., & Carne. H. R. Entero- hepatitis in the peafowl. Austral. Vet. J., 1942, 18: 31.- in'fh?nKi»i *u\'Ur otl l'>stoi.ioniasis, or blackhead infection, M iso 9f-_°VUil ""H' Proc- Am- Acad- A^ Sc, 1934! bJ. 18J-264 6 pl.----— A study of immunity produced by m ect.on with attenuated culture-strains of Histomonas melea- n h' Q;iI0T' lai}-- Loml-i 1M,J- 49: 285-303.--Wenrich. [„a a S observations on Histomonas from wild pheasants TnprAOT27 J- Parasit- Lancaster. 1941, 27: No. 6, HISTONE. See also Albumo.se; Clobin. Versuche1' lirhr'T. X^\^ der Hi.tonc im biologischen > ersucne. ZcSCln . ihyiol. Chem., 1932 205- 154-6______ exTpnlb ^*,H,!!?^k' L ««*r'»akoloKie der Histone. Arch. exp. lath., Berl., 1931, 161: 337; 163: 541. HISTOPATHOLOGY. Set also Biopsy; Histology; Pathology, cellular. Haknard, W. G. Elementary pathological histology. 2. ed. 7 i')\). 19' ntary pathological cm. Lond., 1940. HISTOPATHOLOGY 727 HISTOPATHOLOGY Christeller, E. Atlas der Histotopographie gesunder und erkrankter Organe. 19 [ljp. 88 pl. fol. Lpz., 1927. Defilippo, R. A. Trabajos pr£cticos de histologia patologica. 216p. 23cm. Cordoba, 1937. Delafield, F., & Prudden, T. M. Hand- book of pathological anatomy and histology with an introductory section on post-mortem examina- tions and the methods of preserving and examin- ing diseased tissues. 3. ed. 609p. 8°. N. Y., 1889. Also 4. ed. 715p. 1892. Donaldson, R. Practical morbid histology. 2. ed. 487p. 8? Lond., 1931. Lund, L. Grundriss der pathologischen Histologie der Haustiere. 471p. 8? Hannover, 1931. Mallory, F. B. The principles of pathologic histology. 677p. 8? Phila., 1914. Ogilvie, R. F. Pathological histology. 332p. 22Hcm. Edinb., 1940. Seifried, O. Lehrgang der Histopathologic fiir Studierende und Tierarzte. 195p. 8? Berl., 1934. Bablet, J. Du role et des limites des recherches histopatho- logiques en medecine et en biologie. Biol, mid., Par., 1939, 29: 319-35 —Ellis,E.B. Relation of the technician to the pathol- ogist. Ann. Surg., 1931, 93: 115-8.—Gruner, O. C. Correla- tion of histologic structure with clinical features. J. Lab. Clin. M., 1937-38, 23: 431-4.—Hirsch-Hoffmann. Die Grenzen der histologischen Diagnostik. Mschr. Geburtsh. Gyn., 1934-35, 98: 247.—Letulle, M. Histo-pathologie prati- que; entente cordiale et confiance reciproque. Presse mid., 1927, 35: 645.—Macklin, C. C. The relation of histology to pathology. J. Ass. Am. M. Coll., 1935, 10: 265-84.------ Modern histology in the medical curriculum and its bearing on pathology. Canad. M. Ass. J., 1936, 35: 193-6.—Mowat, G. T. Rapid histology in diagnosis. Tr. R. Med. Chir. Soc. Glasgow, 1937, 31: 120-2.—Orton, S. T. Negative histological findings in experimental organic processes. Univ. Iowa Stud., 1925, 2: No 14 —Shlater, G. G. [Cellular pathology and modern histology] Russ. vrach, 1910, 9: 2107-14. --- Melhods. See also Histology; Microscopy; Microtomy. Schmorl, G. Die pathologisch-histologischen Untersuchungsmethoden. 15. Aufl. 495p. 8? Lpz., 1928. Beatti, E. Lavage de morceaux de tissu par l'usage de I'histopathologie. Zschr. wiss. mikr., 1913, 30: 485-7.—Cain, E. F. A simple method of preparation of tissue for microscopic examination. California West. M., 1935, 43: 291.—Chambers, R., & Ludford, R. J. Microdissection studies on malignant and non-malignant tissue cells. Arch. exp. Zellforsch., 1931-32, 12: 555-69, 2 pl.—Christeller, E. Erfahrungen mit der ver- besserten histologiseh-diagnostischen Sehnellmethode nach Terry. Klin. Wschr.. 1928, 7- 448-50.—Davis, J. E.,&Amolsch. A. L. An attractive cell for thin cross-sections of tissues. Bull. Internat. Ass. M. Mus., Montreal, 1934, No. 13, o4-9.— Davydovsky, I. V. [Practical value of histological analysis ot biopsic material] Klin, med., Moskva, 1928, 6: 791-7. Debenedetti, E. II metodo Terry per la rapida diagnosi lsto- Iogica. Minerva med., Tor., 1928, 8: pt 2, 1225-30 —Dietrich, A. Die Bewertung der pathologisch-histologischen Unter- suchung. Munch, med. Wschr., 1926, 73: 1311.—Dreyfus, J. R., & Scheidegger, S. Ueber den beschrankten Wert der histologischen Sehne!Idiagnose. Zbl. Chir., 1938, 65: L>49- 55.—Elser, W. J., & Olcott, C. T. Preservation of tissue mthe fresh state in paraffin oil in an electric refrigerator. Bull.. Internat. Ass. M. Mus., Montreal, 1934, No. 13 77-80 — Fanz, J. I. The use of sand pa per in the preparation of histologic ground sections of hard substances. Anat. Rec, 1918, 14: 493-6.—Ghizzetti, G. Sulla utilizzazione dei pezzi anatorno- patologici inclusi in gelatina per ricerche istologiche. I atho- logica, Genova, 1925, 17: 523-5.—Gradwohl, R. B. H. the double knife in histo-pathology. Scient. Tr. M. Soc. City Hosp. Alumni St Louis (1901) 1902, 146-52.- Gross, P. A hydraulic automatic tissue changer or immersion device. Arch. .Path., Chic, 1937, 23: 392-8.—Hellwig, A. Zu der Arbeit von S. Hoffheinz: Technik der histologischen Schnelldiagnose. Zbl. Chir., 1928, 55: 77— Hjort, A. M., & Moulton, C.. H. New rapid methods for tissue diagnosis. Stain Techn., 1931, b:8d 91.—Kryspin-Exner, W. Einige_ Bemerkungen zur lechnik Psychiat. neur. iographie; alltaglicher histopathologischer Methoden. Psych Wschr., 1936, 38: 286-8— Lamarque, P. L historad nouvelle technique d'examen des coupes microscopiques. Presse med., 1936, 44: 478-81— Leroux, R. Technique nou- velle pour examens histologiques rapides. Bull. Ass. fr. cancer, 1931, 20: 698-702.—Lubinsky, G. W. Perforated spoons tor handling tissue sections, frozen, paraffin and pyroxylin. Arcn. Path., Chic, 1938, 26: 882.—McLean, J. A round table for use in pathologic histology. J. Lab. Clin. M., 1935-36, 21: 766-9.—Mazza, S. Valor priictico anatomo-quirurgico de los cortes histo-topognificos de Christeller. Prensa m6d. argent., 1926, 13: 9-13.—Morato, M. J. X. A fixacao histologica na pratica medica. Med. contemp., Lisb., 1932, 50: 322-7.— Nelson, I. A. The use of dioxan and acetone for the rapid dehydration and paraffin embedding of fixed tissues. Am. J. Clin. Path., 1937, 7: Suppl., 3-7.—Oelze, F. W. Eine empfeh- lenswerte Vorrichtung fiir Probeexzisionen: das rotierende St.anzmesser. Zschr. wiss. Mikr., 1927, 44: 473-5.—Penny, S. F. A substitute for cover-glasses in mounting pathological sections. Canad. J. M. Techn., 1939-40, 2: 63.—Ricciiiti, G. Sul metodo di Terry per la diagnosi istopatologica inter- operatoria. Gazz. internaz. med. chir., 1930, 38: 70-4.— Robinson, W. L. A method for filing necropsy sections. J. Am. M. Ass., 1917, 69: 2037.—Rothrock, H. A. A modification of technic in Terry's method of rapid tissue diagnosis. J. Lab. Clin. M., 1932, 18: 64.—Rubin, I'. [Histological diagnosis in medical practice] Cluj. med., 1932, 13: 166-70.—Sabrazes, J., & Magrou. E. Diagnostic histologique quasi instantane. par transillumination de segments, de tissue; ou d'organes d'un millimetre environ d'6paisseur badigeonnes, sur la face regar- dant l'objectif, de bleu de toluidine ph<>nique k 1%. Ann. anat. path., Par., 1928, 5: 963-70.—Stafford, E. S. An eosin-methy- lene-blue technique for rapid tissue diagnosis. Bull. Johns Hopkins Hosp., 1934, 55: Sunpl., 229-31— Stojalowski, K. [On transportation of materials for research to histopathological laboratories] Nowiny lek., 1936, 48: 396-8.—Teutschlaender, O. Wie soil Material zur histologischen Untersuchung einge- sandt werden? Zschr. arztl. Fortbild., 1936, 33: 343-5.— Verhaart, W. ,L C. [Fixation of brain for pathological anatomical examination] Geneesk. tschr. Ned. Indie, 1933, 73: 40. ---- Methods: Frozen section. Alter, N. M. Practical use of the frozen section method. Surg. Clin. N. America, 1927, 7: 803-9.—Ansley, H. A.. & Stephens, I. Routine tissue diagnosis by a modified frozen section method. Canad. J. M. Techn., 1938-39, 1: No. 1, 7-10.—Bazy, L. Technique et avantages des coupes histologi- ques faites par la mdthode- de la congelation sur des tissus frais sans fixation prfolable. Hull. Soc. nat. ehir., I'ar., 1930, 56: 550-2.—Broders, A. C. Modification of Wilson's fresh frozen section technic. J. Lab. Clin. M., 1930--31, 16: 734-8 — Caylor, H. D., & Caylor, T. E. An apparatus to faeilitate the preparation of fresh frozen sections. J. Lab. Clin. M., 1930-31, 16: 312.—Caylor, H. D.,& Nickel, A. A.C. Technical considera- tions of fresh and fixed frozen sections. Med. J. & Rec., 1932, 136- 339—Foster, G. S. Bloodgood portable frozen section table. Med. Times, N. Y., 1931, 59: 111.—Gradwohl, R. B. H , & Krajian, A. A. The frozen section method of tissue diagnosis; the method of choice. Gradwohl Lab. Digest, 1940- 41,4: No. 0, 11-5.—Graupner, H., & Weissberger, A. Die Verwendung von Losungen in Dioxan als Fixierungsmittel fiir GefriersehnittO. Zool. Anz., 1933, 102: 39-44.—Guttman, P. H. A rapid method for staining frozen sections. Arch. Path., Chic, 1932, 13: 433-5.—Hoffmann, E. Ueber die Methode des Gefrierschneidens lebensfrischer unfixierter Hautstiicke nach O. Schultz-Brauns (idcale Biopsie) Derm. Zschr., 1931, 62: 5-7.—Hueper, W. C. A simplification of the cooled knife method (Schultz-Brauns) for obtaining frozen sections. Arch. Path., Chic, 1933, 16: 670.—Korenyi, A. [Christeller's im- proved method in restoration of frozen preparations! Magy. orv arch., 1930, 31: 442-5.—Krajian, A. A. A rapid method for the demonstration of reticulum and collagen fibers in frozen sections. Arch. Path., Chic, 1933, 16: 376-8.—Lauche. Erfahrungen mit dem grossen Gefriertisch nach Christeller. Verh Deut. path. Cos., 1926, 21. Kongr.. 313-5.—Lindsay, I W Rice E C, & Selinger, M. A. Frozen sections prepared by use of drv ice. J. Am. M. Ass., 1931, 96: 773—MacCarty, W C The diagnostic reliability of frozen sections. Am.- J. Path " 1929, 5: 377-80, 3 pl.—Michael, E. G. Rapid method of staining' frozen sections of tissues requiring immediate diagnosis. Am. J. Clin. Path., 1940, 4: Techn. Sect 47-9.— Miller, E. G. Frozen section technique. J. K. Micr. hoc, Lond., 1930, 50: 302-0.—Peirce, S. J. S. On the technique of producing frozen sections for rapid diagnosis. Bull. Internat. Ass M. Mus., Montreal, 1915, No. 5. 100-8—Puhr.L. [His- tological method of frozen section of fresh material] Orv. hetil., 1938 82- mell., 5.—Schultz-Brauns, O. Die Vorteile des GefriVrschneidens unfixierter Gewebe fur die histologische Technik. Zbl. allg. Path., 1930-31, 50: 273-7 ——- Erne neue Methode des Gefrierschneidens fur histologische Schnell- untersuchungen. Klin. Wsehr., 1931, 10: 113-6. ——— Verbesserungen und Erfahrungen bei Anwendung der Methode dos Gefrierschneidens unfixierter Gewebe. Zbl. allg L/ath., 1932 54 • 22.5-34.—Schrader, G. Zur Anwendung der Methode des 'Gefrierschneidens unfixierter Gewebe an forensischem Material. Deut. Zsehr. gerichtl. Med. 1934, 23: 172-7.— Scott. G. H., & Williams, P. S A simplified ci-yostat :or the rlehvdration of frozen tissues. Anat. Rec., 1936, 66: 475-81 — Symeonidis, A. Neue Anwendungsmoghchkeiten clei Gefrier- schneidemethode mit Messertiefkuhlung bei nxiertem Gewebe Zbl. allg. Path., 1935, 63: 245,-Szuts A. [New method of transferring frozen sections on glass] Orv. hetil., 1937, 81. «77_q —Ten Berge, B. S. [A new apparatus for making frozen sectionsl Ned techn geneesk., 1924, 68: pt 2, 367-71. Also zX wiss. Mikr., 1925, 42: 157-63.-Thibaudeau A A. The preparation and staining of frozen sections. J. Lab. Urn. HISTOPATHOLOGY 728 HISTOPLASMOSIS M., 1933, 19: 204-9.—Turley, L. A. The difficulties and value of frozen section methods. Ibid.. 1926-27, 12: 492-500.— Zethraeus, S. Modifikation der Sehultz-Braunsschen Gefrier- schnittmethode. Zschr. wiss. Mikr., 1937-38, 54: 408-11. HISTOPHYSIOLOGY. See also Histology; Physiology; Tissue; also under names of physiological functions as Respiration, etc. Ries, E. Grundriss der Histophysiologie. 413p. 22cm. Lpz., 1938. Fen.v, W. O. The differential volumeter for the measurement of cell respiration and other processes. 31p. 8? [Wash. D. C] 1935. Jolly, J. L'histophysiologic et les tendances modernes de l'histologie. Paris mid., 1926, 59:445-56— Noll, A. Probleme der Histophjsiologie. Erg. Physiol., 1933, 35: 50-81.— Okkels, H. L'appareil 'C?sS; ^"mT? °f Da.rlinf- *rch' Int- M- 1940, 65. 902-1 8.^ -Key. .1. A.. & Large, A. M. Histoplasmosis of th; knee. J. Boue M,rt. 1942, 24: 281-90,-MeIeney H. E i-M^10""*-. .^'""'Orepdothehal otomycosis; a review: with mention of 13 unpublished cases. Am. J. Trop. M., 1940' 1Q4!> «. &« ~*T7 Histoplasmosis. N. York State J. M.] 1942, 42: 346.—Negroni. P. Estudio micol6gico del primer caso argentino de histoplasmosis. Fol. biol., B. Air 1938 390 —— - Estudio micologico del primer caeo sud-americann a' histoplasmosis. Rev. Inst. bact. Dep. naT hi" B A?r 104?. 9: 23^94,-Parsons R. J. The histopltholog\ of hooplas' mosis in man. Am. J. Path., 1941, 17: 582-4.-karr.sey 4P L § .Av.PP,f^anUm' A" A" Histoplasmosis Darling \m J Clin" Path., 1942, 12: 85-94.-Redaelli. P. L'eprluve: pexiaue au rouge Congo dans l'histoplasmose experimenLV (Xculo histiocyte systematique par Histoplasma capsulatum Darling) Boll. Sez. ital. Soc. internaz. microb., 1935, 7: 312- 6. Also Boll. Soc. ital. biol. sper., 1935, 10: 812-5._____ La reticolo-istiocitosi systematica sperimentale da Histoplasma capsulatum Darling. Arch. ital. anat. pat., 1936, 7: Scritti 35-69.------Osservazioni e considerazioni su alcuni aspctti anatomici e funzionali del sistema reticolo-istiocitario nella malattia sperimentale da Histoplasma capsulatum Darlinc Hiv. pat. sper., 1938, 20: 1-60. ------■ & (ifcrri. R. Etudes sur l'Histoplasma capsulatum Darling; reproduction experi- mentale de l'histoplasmose, et definition de la maladie comme r6ticolo-histoc\-tose parasitaire atteignant divers systemes de l'organisme. Boll. Sez. ital. Soc. internaz. mierob lost «- 193-5.—Reid, J. I).. Scherer, J. H. let al.] Hvstemic l,i.st,,-' plasmosis diagnosed before death and produced experimentally in guinea pigs. J. Lab. Clin. M., 1941-42, 27: 419-31 — Rhodes, P. H., Conanat, N. F., & Glesne, L. It. B. 11 i.-itr>- plasmosis; report of case in an infant 3 months of age I Pediat., S. Louis, 1941, 18: 235-41.—Riley, W. A., & Watson] C. J. Histoplasmosis of Darling; with report of a case origi- nating in Minnesota. Am. J. Trop. M., 1926, 6: 271-82.— Scott, E. P. Histoplasmosis; report of a case in an infant 1 5 months of age. J. Pediat., S. Louis, 1941, 19: 668-71 — Shaffer, F. J., Shaul, J. F., & Mitchell, R. H. Histoplasmosis of Darhng; fourth case to be reported in United States. J Am M. Ass., 1939, 113: 484-8.—Shaul, J. F. Histoplasmosis of Darling. In Pract. Libr. M. & S. (Appleton) N. Y., 1940, Suppl 208-16.—Van Pernis, P. A. Histoplasmosis; visceral changes demonstrated by postmortem examination. Proc Inst M Chicago, 1942-43, 14: 109. ------Benson, M. E., & Hoi inner' P. H. Specific cutaneous reactions with histoplasmosis; pre- liminary report of another case. J. Am. M. Ass., 1941,' H7: 436.—Villela, E., & Madureira Para. Histosplasmos'e enj erianca no estado de Minas Gerais. Rev. brasil. biol., 1941 1: 449-56.—Wall. R. E. Review of the disease histoplasmosis' China M. J., 1928, 42: 580.—Watson, C. J. The pathology of histoplasmosis (Darling) with special reference to the origin of the phagocytic cells. Fol. haemat., Lpz., 1928, 37: 70-93 5 pl.—Williams, R. H., & Cromartie, W. J. Histoplasmosis' report of a case. Ann. Int. M., 1939-40, 13: 2166-71 —' Wright, R. B., & Hachtcl, F. W. Histoplasmosis of Darling- report of a case. Ibid., 1941-42, 15: 309-19.—Zarafonetis, ('' J. D., & Lindberg, R. B. Histoplasmosis of Darling; observa- tions on the antigenic propreties of the causative agent- a preliminary report. Univ. Hosp. Bull., Ann Arb., 1941, 'l; HISTORICAL bulletin. Calgary, v.l, 1936- HISTORICUS, pseud. Cocoa; all about it 114p. 12 pl. 12? Lond., S. Low, Marston & co., 1892. HISTORY. See also Anthropogeography; Archaeology; Civilization; Culture; Demography, etc.; also names of countries, nations, and races. Diodoros Siculus (of Agyrion) De anti- quorum gestis fabulosis lib. 1-6. exxiii (i e 124) [6] 1. 16cm. [text] Par. [ca 1510-15] Heilprin, L. The historical reference book comprising a chronological table of universal history; a chronological dictionary of universal history; a biographical dictionary. Rev. to 1899 6. ed. 592p. 8? N. Y., 1913. Hoffmann, P. T. Der mittelalterliche Mensch. 2. Aufl. 313p. 8? Lpz., 1937. Knight, C. R. Before the dawn of history. 119p. 4? N. Y. [1935] Nagel, E. Zwei Jahrzehnte in der wissen- schafthchen Vereimgung der Erfurter Geschichts- freunde. 33 1. 4? Erfurt, 1932. Payne, E. W. The immortal stone age. 95p. 21cm. Chic. [1938] ri9S301TH' °' Human history- 5°9p- 8? Lond. 8oV°BrT'lJ'iq?7Sere Stellung zur Antike. 16p. Yale University Press. The new historians, a booklet about the authors of the Chronicles of America. 48p. 23cm. N. Y. [1921?] R ^^i8uj£re" KA-o,?73]listc""!a como ciencia- Sem. med., L^'-rL™' t8: Pt 2-' i294!6-; Groos- K- Historische Situa^ tonen; Bemerkungen uber ihr V. eser, und ihre Vergegenwarti- f™S- Zscfir Psychol. Physiol. *"»<*<>*., L Abt., 1936, 139: hiVwil • natlcm [n. p., 1930] HOARE, Alfred, 1850- A short Italian dictionary. 2. ed. 2v. xxvip.l. 4 13p; vii, 421p. 8? Cambr., Univ. press, 1931-33. ----An Italian dictionary. 2. ed. xxxii, 906p. 4? Cambr., Univ. press, 1935. HOARE, Edward Wallis, 1863-1920. Hoare's Veterinary materia medica & therapeutics. 5. ed. revised by J. Russell Greig. viii, 510p. H°. Lond., Bailliere, Tindall & Cox, 1933. HOARSENESS. See also Aphonia; Voice, Disorder; also names of primary diseases as Esophagus, Cancer; Laryngitis; Larynx, Cancer, etc. Asherson, N. Hoarseness. Clin. J., Lond., 1930, 59: 457- (14.—Barr, T. Hoarseness. Texas J. M., 1938-39, 34: 553- 5.—Colledge, L. Hoarseness. Med. Press & Circ, Lond., 1937, 195: 552-4.—Frank, D. I. Hoarseness, a new classification and a brief report of 4 interesting cases. Laryngoscope, 1940, 50: 472-8.—Hoarseness. South. M. & S., 1940, 102: 727. Krieger, W. A. Etiology, symptoms, and diagnosis of the inflammatory type of hoarseness. N. York State J. M., 1934, 34:47. LeJeune, F. E. Hoarseness. Surg. Gvn. Obst., 1938. 66: 405 S. Also In ( vc-lop. Med. (Piersol-Bortz) Phila., 1939, 7: 280-90; 1911, Serv. Vol., 468-70.------Hoarseness (color motion picture demonstration) Mississippi Doctor, 1938-39, 16: No. 4, 33.—Lewis, H. Hoarseness. S. Africa M. J., 1932, 6: 362-6.—Lischkoff, M. A. Hoarseness. J. Florida M. Ass., 1935-36, 22: 263-5.—Patterson, N. Hoarseness. Lancet, Lond., 1936, 2: 1112.—Powers, H. W. Hoarseness. J. Kansas M. Soc, 1938, 39: 413-7.—Swinburne, G. Hoarse- ness. Melbourne Hosp. Clin. Rep., 1939, 10: 127-30 — Tracewell, G. L. Hoarseness. J. Oklahoma M. Ass., 1941, 34: 427-9.—Voorhees, I. W. Hoarseness in children. Eve Ear &c. Month., 1937-38, 16: 159—Watkyn-Thomas, F. W. Hoarseness. Practitioner, Lond., 1936, 137: 081-90.—Wood- ward, F. D. Hoarseness. Dis. Eye &c. Throat, 1941, 1: 157-00. ---- chronic. Carpenter, E. W., & Carpenter, W. M. Chronic hoarseness J. S. Carolina M. Ass., 1937, 33: 287-91.—Cleveland, C. H. Chronic hoarseness. J. M. Ass. Alabama, 1935-36, 5: 119- 22.—Damitz, J. C, & Dill, J. L. Chronic hoarseness; report of lion consecutive eases. Ann. Otol. Rhinol., 1940, 49: 996- 1007.—Klestadt. Rachenmandcl und chronisphe Heiserkeit bei Jugendlichen. Zschr. Laryng., 1931, 21: 565-70.—Moore, P. M., jr. Chronic hoarseness. Dis. Eye &c. Throat, 1941, 1: 68-73.—Nadoleczny, M. Wodurch kann eine chronische Heiserkeit bedingt sein? Munch, med. Wschr., 1935, 82: 13-6.—Ormerod, F. C, & Davis, E. D. Chronic huskiness of 3 years' duration following a cold. J. Lar. Otol., bond., 1910, 55: 226.—Seiffert, A. Diagnostik der chronischen Hui.serkeit. Zschr. arztl. Fortbild., 1935, 32: 129-32.—Tilley, H. Chronic hoarseness: its diagnosis and treatment. Clin. J., Lond., 1931, 60: 529-38. Also Med. J. Australia, 1933, 2: 169-74.—Waugh. J. M. The significance of chronic hoarseness in adults. Proc. Interst. Postgrad. M. Ass. N. America (1928) 1929, 522-5. Also Internat. Clin., 1929, 39. ser., 3: 60-7, 8 pl.— Zange, J. Y odurch kann eine chronische Heiserkeit bedingt sein? Miinch. med. Wschr., 1934, 81: 701-3. , ---- Differential diagnosis. Daily, L. Hoarseness: a danger signal. South. M. J., 1931, 24:1041-9. Also repr.- Friedman, E. D. Neurological aspects of hoarseness. N. York State J. M., 19.34, 34: 48-50.-Frii- schels, E. Gesetzmassigkeiten in der Erscheinung und Ent- wicklung der hyperfunktionellen Heiserkeiten. Mschr. Ohrenh., Wien, 1937, 71: 400-6—Glushak, L. Dysphonia HOARSENESS 731 HOBBY spastica (spastic hoarseness) Laryngoscope, 1928, 38: 273- g.—Hanau, G. II significato clinico della raucedine. Gazz. osp., 1933, 54: 1179-83.—Hirsch, C. Hoarseness; what it means to patient and physician. Med. Rec, N. Y., 1935, 141: 36-8.—Jackson, C. Hoarseness; differential diagnosis of the manifold diseases accompanied by this symptom. Proc. Interst. Postgrad. M. Ass. N. America, 1934, 23-7.------ Benign laryngeal lesions producing hoarseness (diagnosis and treatment) Tr. Am. Laryng. Ass., 1935, 41: 128-40.—Jones, D. H. Tuberculous, malignant, and syphilitic types of hoarse- ness. N. York State J. M., 1934, 34: 59—LeJeune, F. E. Hoarseness, its significance; motion picture demonstration. N. Orleans M. & S. J., 1934, 87: 5-9. ------ The significance of hoarseness. Texas J. M., 1937-38, 33: 51375. -LeTellier, F. S. Some conditions causing hoarseness. J. Tennessee M. Ass., 1933, 26: 197-9.—Leuzinger, J. E. Hoarseness, is it benign or malignant? J. Am. Osteopath. Ass., 1941-42, 41: 289.— Liggett, H. The mechanism of hoarseness, its medical and neurological aspects. Med. Clin. N. America, 1938, 22: 1463- 72.—Maxwell, J. H. The significance of chronic hoarseness. J. Michigan M. Soc, 1937, 36: 20-5.—Mes, L. [Functional hoarseness] Ned. tschr. geneesk., 1931. 25: pt 3, 3990.— Negus, V. E. The significance of hoarseness. N. York State J. M., 1939, 39: 9-12.—Schroder, T. Ueber Heiserkeit infolge verkehrter Stimmbildung und deren Heilung. Mschr. Ohrenh., 1932, 66: 343-0.—Vogel, K. Die differentialdiagnostische Bedeutung der Heiserkeit. Med. Welt. 1934, 8: 260-3.— Wagers, A. J. The clinical significance of hoarseness. Penn- sylvania M. J., 1936-37, 40: 14-8.—Waugh, J. M. The significance of chronic hoarseness in adults. Cleveland Clin. Q., 1936, 3: 300-10.—Wells, W. The significance of hoarseness. Ann. Otol. Rhinol., 1940, 49: 99-112. Also Med. Surg. Sug- gestions, Madras, 1940, 9: 319-30. ---- Treatment. Bitiutzky, I. G. [Case of cicatricial hoarseness and its treat- ment] Vrach. delo. 1929, 12: 423.—Bruggemann, A. Die Heiserkeit und ihre Behandlung. Med. Klin., Ber!., 1933, 29: 1099.—Finder, G. Heiserkeit und ihre Behandlung. Deut. med. Wschr., 1927, 53: 1217-21.—GJas, E. Behandlung der Heiserkeit. Aerztl. Prax., Wien, 1931, 5: 129-32. Also Wien. klin. Wschr., 1931, 44: 479-83.—Negus, V. E. The diagnosis and treatment of hoarseness. Med. J. Australia, 1933, 2: 591- 5.—Strasser, A. Die Johanneshymne, ein Cebet heiserer Sanger an die Gottheit. Med. Welt, 1932, 6: 758-60.—Vogel, K. Die Behandlung der chronischen Heiserkeit. Ther. Gegenwart, 1936. 77: 15; 71.—Voorhees. I. W. The non- surgical treatment of aphonia (hoarseness) N. York State J. M., 1934, 34: 53-5. HOBAN, C. F. See McClusky, F. Dean, Hoban, C. F. [et al.] The place of visual instruction in the modern school [&c] roy. 8? [n. p.] 1930. HOBART, Frederick George, & MELTON, George. A concise pharmacology of the more important drugs, together with an outline of their therapeutic applications and an introduction to the art of prescribing, xiii, 171p. 19cm. Lond., L. Hill [1937] ---- The same. O essencial em farmacologia; estudo farmacol6gico das drogas mais impor- tantes, incluindo um esquema das suas aplicacoes terapeuticas e uma introducao a arte de formular. Trad, pelo Dr M. Rocha e Silva. xiii, 194p. 22cm. Brooklyn, N. Y., Ed. Tecnica Unida, 1942. HOBBES, Thomas. Leviathan, p. 107-200. 12? Garden City, N. Y., Doubleday, Doran [1937] In Kennedy, G., Francis Bacon, N. Y., 1937. HOBBS, Angier Bailey, 1864-1938. [Obituarvl Abstr. Proc. Ass. Life Insur. M. Dir. America, 1938, 25: 289. HOBBS, Horton H., jr. Seven new crayfishes of the genus Cambarus from Florida, with notes on other species, p.387-423. 8? Wash., 1940. Forms No. 3097, v.89, Proc. U. S. Nat, Mus. HOBBS, John E., 1901- A manual of obstetrical and gynecological pathology, pri- marily for students; prepared under the super- vision of Dr Otto H. Schwarz. 4 p. 1. 186p. 23Hcm. S. Louis, S. Scott, 1936. HOBBS, Remington, 1874-1932. [Obituary] Brit. M. J., 1932, 1: 1106. HOBBS, William, 1822-1890. McCallum, F. [Biography] Health, Melb., 1927, 5: 98-101. HOBBY. See also Psychotherapy; Recreation; also under names of hobbies. intten?.^,"". VA TkVu1^0"?^15 between children's tested 1041 «" W 9their hobby participations. J. Genet. Psychol., irfrk n r ■-Hamilton. J. R The practical use of hobbies in the practice of medicine. Ann. Int. M., 1936 9- 1129-33 — lQon7S'i?-. ?£ *o,iliftr-v readins as a hobby. 'Mil. Surgeon, 19o7, 81: 18-52. Also repr.—Millar, F. G. A. Patients flv i/2cm. Charlottenb., K. & R. Hoffmann, 1936. HOCHREIN, Max, 1897- Der Coronar- krcislauf; Physiologie, Pathologie, Therapie. vii, 227p. illust. diagrs. 8? Berl., J. Springer. 1932. ---- Der Myokardinfarkt; Erkennung, Be- handlung, und Verhiitung. viii, 196p. illust. 24cm. Dresd., T. Steinkopff, 1937. Bd 1, Kreislauf-Biicherei. HOCHSINGER, Carl, 1860- Ueber das Kongenitalitatsproblem der Syphilis. 53p. 8! Berl., S. Karger, 1926. Forms H. 15, Abh. Kinderh. HOCHSTAEDT, Hermann. *L'asthme chez les enfants. 50p. 23cm. Lausanne, R. Duruz & C. Combe, 1938. HOCHSTETTER, Ferdinand, 1861- Editor of Toldt, Carl. Anatomischer Atlas fiir Studierende und Aerzte [&c] 15. Aufl. 3v. 8? Berl., 1931. For Festschrift see Zschr. ges. Anat., 1. Abt., 1931, 94: portr. For biography see Med. KUn., Berl., 1941, 37: 149 (A. Pichler) Also Wien. klin. Wschr., 1931, 44: 208; 1941, 54: 107, portr (E. Pernkopf) Also Wien. med. Wschr., 1931, 81: 215 (A. Kronfeld) Also Zschr. ges. Anat., 1. Abt., 1931, 94: p. iii, portr (J. Schaffer) Sec also Grosser, O. Dasbisherige wissenschaftliche Lebens- werk Ferdinand Hochstetters; als Gratulaticmsschrift zum 80. Geburtstag. Wien. klin. Wschr., 1941, 54: 108-10. For portrait see Billroth's Assistenten von 1867-89 (portrait assembly) HOCHSTETTER, Gustav, & ZEHDEN, Georg Mit Horrohr und Spritze; ein lustiges Buch fiir Aerzte und Patienten. 216p. 8? Berl., Eysler & co., 1914. HOCHULI, Arthur. *Beitrage zur Geschichte der Mundhygiene im 18. Jahrhundert [Zurich] 64p. 8? Laupen, Polygraph. Ges., 1923. HOCHULI 733 HOCS HOCHULI, Hans. *Die typischen Kniever- letzungen des Fussballspiels [Bern] 20p. 24cm. Aarburg, A. Humm, 1940. HOCHWAHR, Liselotte, 1905- *Der Einfluss des Ernahrungszustandes auf die Haufig- keit der Zahnkaries im Kindesalter. 24p. 4 tab. 8? Miinst. [n. pub.] 1931. HOCK, Emil [Alois] 1906- *Die Ein- wirkung giftigen Staubes und giftiger Dampfe auf Zahne und Mundhohle. 38p. 8? Wurzb., C. J. Becker, 1931. HOCK, Franz. *Die Kastanie der Equiden; ihre Entwicklung, ihre Struktur, ihr Wert zur Rasse- und Exterieurbeurteilung und die wahr- scheinliche Ursache ihres Vorhandenseins [Bern] 52p. pl. 8? Bad Kissingen, C. H. Rath, 1910. HOCK, Fritz, 1901- *Untersuchungen iiber den Bau und Keimgehalt der Lagerstiitten des Strongylus paradoxus in den Lungen des Schweines. 20p. 8? [Giessen, K. Hansult] 1928. HOCK, Max, 1900- *Ueber die Geburten im Entwicklungsalter an der Wiirzburger Uni- versitats-Frauenklinik in den Jahren 1909-25. 24p. 8? Wiirzb. [n. pub.] 1926. HOCK, Theodor, 1890- *Ueber die Bedeutung von Kopftraumen (mit Gehirner- schiitterung) fiir die Entstehung essentieller Hypertonien. 43p. 8? Bonn, L. Neuendorff, 1929 HOCKE, Johannes [Maria Joseph] 1909- *Versuche mit einem neuen Desinfektionsmittel (Praparat 4746 der I. G. Farben-Industrie) [Breslau] 16p. 8? Frankenstein [n. pub.] 1934. HOCKEMEYER, Herbert, 1909- *Er- gebnisse der Glaukombehandlung an der Uni- versitats-Augenklinik zu Wurzburg in den Jahren 1932-33 [Wurzburg] 13p. 7 tab. 8? Wer- theim, E. Bechstein, 1936. HOCKENJOS, Ernst. *Beitrag zu den cere- bralen Affectionen bei Keuchhusten [Basel] p.425-45. 8? Lpz., B. G. Teubner, 1900. HOCKER, Elizabeth Van Cortlandt. Hocker. E. V. C. The personal experience of a contract surgeon in the United States Army [1917-18] Med. Woman J., 1942, 49: 9-11, portr. (cover) HOCKETT, Afsabel] J., 1905- Biography. Hosp. Topics, 1939, 17: No. 2, 11. HOCKEY. Arnold, A. Ueber Hockeyverletzungen. Deut. med. Wschr., 1931, 57: 2175-7.—Glass, E. Hockeyverletzungsstatistik. Ibid., 1927, 53: 1907.------ Die Aufgaben des Sportarztes beim Hockey. Ibid., 1934, 60: 1562. ------ & Erichson, P. Puis- und Gewichtsuntersuchungen beim Hockeyspiel. Ibid., 1926, 52: 1649.—Lupandina, N. A. [Results of pedagogic con- trol in the hockey sports school] Teor. prakt. fiz. kult., Moskva, 1939, 3: No. 3, 23-9.—Schmid, L. [Injuries in hockey] Cas. 16k. fesk., 1941, 80: 302-4.—Schmithals, M., & French, E. Achievement tests in field hockey for college women. Res. Q. Am. Ass. Health, 1940, 11: No. 3, 84-92. HOCKIN, Munro May, 1893-1939. Obituary. N. Zealand M. J., 1939, 38: 428. HOCKING, Silas Kitto, 1850- An inter- rupted romance, vi, 291p. 12? Lond., Sampson Low, Marston & co. [1923] HOCKLEY, A. R. See Mangham, S., & Hockley, A. R. Biology for pharma- ceutical students and others. 613p. 22J4cm. Lond., 1938. HOCKS, Adolf, 1907- *Heilen die Frakturen l-knochiger Gliedabschnitte schneller als die 2-knochiger? [Leipzig] 20p. 8? Zeulen- roda, A. Oberreuter, 1933. HOCQUARD, Jean, 1912- *Serums et antiseptiques; quelques experiences sur la possi- bilite' d'une action combinee, in vitro, des serums specifiques et des antiseptiques. 60p. 24>^cm. Par., Vigot freres, 1939. HOCS, Samuel. ^Oligodynamic von Metall- salzlosungen [Basel] 20p. 8? Buer-Resse i. W K. Stollbrock, 1931. ,>/H9 ^ac Cung' 1907~ Contribution a 1 etude des complications puerpgrales d'origine endogene en Indochine. 39p. 8? Par., Jouve & cie., 1937. HO-DAC-DI, 1901- *Du procede de Witzel dans la gastrostomie. 53p. 8? Par., Rev. path, comp., 1929. HODANGER, Marcel, 1899- ♦Contri- bution a l'etude des hypertensions arterielles des adultes jeunes. 116p. 8? Par., A. Legrand 1930. B HODANN, Max, 1894- History of modern morals; transl. by Stella Browne, xv. 338p. 8? Lond., W. Heinemann, 1937. HODARA, Menahem, -1926. Unna, P. G. Nekrolog. Derm. Wschr., 1926, 83: 1681. HODDAEUS, Konrad, -1597. Physicae quaestiones [12] 1. 8? Lemgo, heirs of Conr. Grothenus, 1590. Bound to Godelman, J. G. Tract, de magis. Frankf., 1591. HODDER-WILLIAMS, John Ernest, 1876- 1927. Obituary. Lancet, Lond., 1927, 1: 847. HODEL, H. *Beitrag zur Frage der Geburts- prognose nach Prolapsoperationen, Amputation des Cervix und der Vaginalportion [Bern] 48p. 8? Luzern, H. Keller, 1940. HODEL, M. Angelina. Korperlehre und Gesundheitspflege auf religioser Grundlage. 2. Aufl. x, 272p. illust. 8: Freib. i. B., Herder & co. [1924] HODEL, Peter. *Petroleumvergiftungen ins- besondere ein Fall von Pneumonie durch Petro- leum. 23p. 8? Geneve [n. pub.] 1931. HODENBERG, Dietrich von, 1909- *Er- gebnisse der Trochanterimplantation bei Schen- kelhalsfrakturen. 24p. 21cm. Berl. [n. pub.] 1936. HODER, Friedrich. Bakterienveranderung durch Bakteriophagenwirkung. 3 p. 1. 120p. 8? Jena, G. Fischer, 1932. ---- Der Verkehr des praktischen Arztes mit der bakteriologischen Untersuchungsstation. vii, 126p. 8? Jena, G. Fischer, 1G35. ---- Bakteriologie und Hygiene des taglichen Lebens; ein Lehr- und Lesebuch fiir alle. viii, 210p. 8? Jena, G. Fischer, 1937. HODGDON, A. R., Mills, M. E., & Clapp, H. S. Protecting our native plants. 12p. 8? Dur- ham, 1940. Forms Circ. 230, N. Hampshire Ext. Serv. HODGE, Hugh Lenox, 1796-1873. Thorns, H. Hugh Lenox Hodge, a master mind in obstetri- cal science. Am. J. Obst., 1937, 33: 886-92, portr. HODGEN, John Thompson, 1826-82. Mudd. H. G. [Biography] Surg. Gyn. Obst., 1926, 42: 579-81.—Smith, E. S. Remarks at the unveiling of the Hodgen memorial plaque commemorative of the life of our foremost surgeon, Dr John Thomson Hodgen. J. Missouri M. Ass., 1934, 31: 203-7. HODGEN, Joseph Dupuy, 1865- Prac- tical dental metallurgy; a text- and reference- book for students and practitioners of dentistry. 1 ed. 314p. 8? S. Franc, Hicks-Judd co., 1896. Also 2. ed. 349p. 1897. Also 7. ed. see next entry. ---- MILLBERRY, Guy Stillman, & SHELL, John S. Practical dental metallurgy; a text and reference book for students and practitioners of dentistry, embodying the principles of metallurgy, and their application to dentistry, including experiments. 7. ed. 470p. 8? S. Louis, C. V. Mosby co., 1932. HODGES 734 HODOYER HODGES, Fred Jenner, 1895- , & PECK, Willis Seamans. Introduction to radiology; a syllabus of courses 130, 131, and 133 in the curriculum of the Medical School of the Univer- sity of Michigan. vii, 263p. illust. diagr. 28 x 21 Vm. Ann Arb., Edwards bros, inc., 1939. For portrait, see Univ. Hosp. Bull., Ann Arb., 194i, 7: 74. Also Texas J. M., 1941-42, 37: 797. HODGES, Nathaniel, 1629-1688. Evans, G. H. IBiographv] Ann. M. Hist., 1910, 3. ser., 2: 79 81. HODGES, Paul Chesley, 1893- , PHEMI- STER, Dallas Burton, & BRUNSCHWIG, Alexander. The Roentgen-ray diagnosis of diseases of the bones and joints, vi, 242, Sp. illust. diagr. 25 x 19cm. X. Y., T. Nelson & sons, 1938. HODGKIN, E. P. Anopheles hyrcanus Pallas as a malaria carrier in Malaya. 6p. 25cm. Kuala Lumpur, Fed. Malay States Gov. Press, 1933. Forms Pt No. 1, Bull. Inst, M. Res. Malay, 1933. See also I'oynton, .1. Orde, & Hodgkin, E. P. Endemic filariasis in the Federated Malay States. 67p. 24Hcm. Kuala Lumpur, 1938. ----& JOHNSTON, R. S. Malaria at Batu Ga.jah, Perak: transmitted by Anopheles bar- birostris Van der Wulp. 19p. map. diagr. 2 pl. 25cm. Kuala Lumpur, Fed. Malay States Gov. Press, 1935. Forms Pt No. 1, Bull. Inst. M. Res. Malay, 1935. HODGKIN, E. P., & RAJAMONEY, P. D. A descriptive and biological note on the Malayan varieties of Anopheles hyrcanus Pallas, p.7-18; 2 pl. 25cm. Kuala Lumpur, Fed. Malay States Gov. Press, 1933. Forms Pt No. 1, Bull. Inst. M. Res. Malay. 1933. HODGKIN, Thomas, 1798-1866. Biography. Med. Classic.-, 1936 37. 1: 731-40, portr.— Fox. H. Uemarks on the presentation of microscopical prepa- rations made from some of the oiiginal tissue described by Thomas Hodgkin, 1832. Ann. M. Hist., 1920, 8: 370-4. Also Guy's Hosp. Rep., Lond., 1936, 86: 11-6. HODGKIN'S DISEASE. See Granuloma malignum. HODGKINSON, Alexander, 1846-1928. Obituary. Brit. M. .1., 1928. 1: 527. HODGMAN, Charles David, 1881- Kditor of (Chemical Rubber Company, Cleveland) Hand- book of chemistrv and physics. 21.-22. ed. 2023p.; 2069p. 16? Clevel. [1936-37] Also 25. ed. 2503p. 18^cm. 1941. HODGSON, Joseph, 1788-1869. IBiography] Cat. Portr. R. Coll. Surgeons. Lond., 1930, 31. HODGSON, Violet Hoffman, 1888- Public health nursing in industry, xxii, 249p. diagrs. pl. 8? X. Y., Macmillan co., 1933. —-— Handbook on tuberculosis for public health nurses. 5 p. 1. 92p. 21cm. X. Y., Nat. Tuberc. Ass., 1939. ---- Supervision in public health nursing. xii, 376p. diagr. 23'^cm. X. Y., Common- wealth fund, 1939. HODGSON, W. B. Two lectures on the con- ditions on health and wealth, educationally con- sidered. 68p. 16? Edinb., J. Gordon, 1860. HODGSON, William, 1854-1940. Obituary. Lancet. Lond., 1940, 1: 432.—Picton, L. J. Obituary-. Brit. M. J., 1940, 1: 324. lor portrait, see Lancet, Lond., 1940, 1: 432. HODITZ, Herbert, 1908- *Ueber die morphologischen Variationen des normalen menschlichen Kieferapparates und ihre Beziehun- gen zu seinen Bewejmngsbahnen [Frankfurt] 32p. 8? Zeulenroda, B. Sporn, 1934. HODNETT, Edward. English woodcuts, 1480-1535. xv, 483p. pl. 4? Lond., Bibliogr Soc. (1934) 1935. HODOYER, Georges Marie Adolphe, 1!M)s ♦Contribution a l'etude des p6ritoiiit.es aigues primitives chez l'enfant. 5Np. 25cm Bord., J. Bic-re, 1934. HODSDON, Sir James William Beeman, 1858-1928. Obituary. Brit. M. J., 1928, 1: 1003. Also Lancet, Lond 192S. 1: 1154.—S.. W. J. Obituary. Edinburgh M. J., 192S n. ser., 35: 405-9, portr. HODSON, Eleanor, -1936. Obituary. Lancet, Lond., 1936, 1: 746. An occult view of health ? Lond., Theosoph. pub. HODSON, Geoffrey. and disease, xii, 52p. house [1925] ---- The miracle of birth; a clairvoyant study of prenatal life. 2. reprint. 69p. 8? Lond., Theosoph. pub. house [1936] HOEBEL, E. Adamson. The political organi- zation and law-ways of the Comanche Indians. 149p. 241)Cin. Menasha, Am. Anthrop. Ass., 1940. Forms No. 54, Mem. Am. Anthrop. Ass. HOEBER, Rudolf [Otto Anselm] 1873- Physikalische Chemie der Zeile und der Gewebe. 6. Aufl. xvi, 955p. 8? Lpz., W. Engelmann, Lehrbuch der Phvsiologie des Menschen. viii, 5S0p. 8° Berl., J. Springer, 1928. Aufl. viii, 593p. 1930. Also 6. Aufl. 302 illust. 1931. Also S. Aufl. illust. diagr. 25cm. Bern, Stampfli 1926. ■L Aufl. Also 5 viii, 609p viii, 650p. & cie, 1939. ---- Das Lebendige als Objekt naturwissen- schaftlicher Forschung. 19p. 8? Kiel, Lipsius & Tischer, 1930. HOECHERL, Johann [Baptist Simon] 1911- * Ueber die Behandlungsergebnisse der autophistischen Knochentransplantation bei Pseudarthrosen an der Wurzburger chirurgischen Universitatsklinik von 1935 zu 1937. 24p. 22J/2cm. Wiirzb. [n. pub.] 1938. HOE( HSTAEDTER, Erna, 1908- *Bei- trage zur Pharmakologie des Tlopfens. 21p. 8? Wurzb., Werkbund Verb, 1931. HOECHT, Joseph, 1907- *Nachunter- suchung der an der II. Universitats-Klinik fiir Frauenkrankheiten und Geburtshilfe zu Munchen vom 1. X. 1920 zu 31. XII. 1931 operierten ma- lignen Ovarialtumoren [Munchen] 24p. 8? Kallmiinz, M. Lassleben, 1933. HOECKER [Georg Herrmann] Erich, 1908- * Ueber Zystenentwicklung im Ductus nasopalatinus. 20p. 8? Wiirzb., R. Mayr, 1933. HOECKER, Ulrich. Beitrage zur Kenntnis der Sexualvorgange des Karakulschafes in Hin- blick auf die kunstliche Besamung. p.29-77. 25cm. Berl., P. Parey, 1938. HOEDE, Karl, 1897- *Beitrage zur Statistik, Aetiologie und Pathogenese der Psori- asis vulgaris unter besonderer Berucksichtigung der Erblichkeit. 39p. ch. 8? Wurzb., C. J. Becker, 1927. ---- Umwelt und Erblichkeit bei der Entste- hung der Schuppenflechte [Habilitationssehrift; Wurzburg] p.211-54. 8? Lpz., C. Kabitzsch, 1931. Also Wiirzb. Abh. Med., 1931, 27: HOEDERATH [Peter] Max Josef, 1895- *Findet ein Stoffwechsel in den Zahnen statt? 30p. 8? [Bonn, n. pub.] 1926. HOEEGH, Johannes von, 1896- * Ueber amyloid-nephrotische Schrumpfniere luischen Ur- sprungs. 14p. 8? Rostock, Adler, 1933. HOEER 735 HOEFINGHOFF HOEER, Erwin, 1911- *Ueber den Verwendungsstoffweehsel anaerober Baeillen; Te- tanus, Botulinus, Gasbrand und Pararausch- brand. 31p. 22cm. Berl., H. Michel, 1938. HOEFELMAYR, Annemarie, 1908- *To- desfalle bei Eklampsie an der Jenaer Frauen- klinik aus den Jahren 1930 bis 1935 [Jena] 21p. 8? Gunzb., K. Mayer, 1937. HOEFER. Der Einfluss von tierischen Er- krankungen auf Kriegsausgange. 64p. 8" Berl., E. S. Mittler & Sohn, 1930. Forms Ergiinzbd. 2, Zschr. Vetcrinark. --- Das italienische Militar-Veterinarwesen unter Friedens- und Kriegsverhaltnissen. 40p. 8? Berl., E. S. Mittler & Sohn, 1934. Forms Erganzbd 7, Zschr. Veterinark. HOEFER, Annemarie, 1907- *Ueber Molketherapie [Halle] 15p. 2 pl. 8? Bleiche- rode, C. Nieft, 1935. HOEFER [Anton Franz] Werner, 1908- *Ueber die analgetische Wirkung von Morphin und seiner Kombinationen mit Sehlafmitteln. 14p. 3 ch. 8? Halle, H. John, 1932. HOEFER, Carolyn H. See Hardy, Martha C, & Hoefer, Carolyn H. Healthv growth. 360p. 8° Chic. [1936] HOEFER, Inge, 1910- *Eisen und Blut- bildung. 24p. 8? Greifsw., E. Panzig & co., 1934. HOEFER, Kathe, 1908- *Querulanten- wahn bei Ehegatten [Konigsberg] 39p. 8: Berl., Triltsch & Huther, 1935. HOEFER, Maria, 1904- *Ueber Cysten- nieren und Cystenleber bei Neugeborenen mit Bekanntgabe eigener Falle [Bonn] 31p. 8: [Libau, G. D. Meyer] 1931. HOEFER, Paul, 1903- *Ueber die Be- einflussung der Hautsinnesqualitaten durch Mor- phin und ahnliche Praparate, zugleich ein Beitrag zur Kenntnis des Morphinismus [Wurzburg] p.21-36. 8? Miinch., J. F. Lehmann [1929] Also Zschr. Biol., 1929-30, 89: HOEFER, Rudolf, 1899- *Ueber Hirn- komplikationen im Verlaufe von Keuchhusten 24p. 8? Gott, [n. pub.] 1927. HOEFER, Walter, 1908- *Die Bedeutung der Hochstwehenzahlen und Durchschnittswehen- zahlen bei rechtzeitigem und friihzeitigem Blasen- sprung [Berlin] 30p. 8? Bochum, H. Popping- haus, 1934 HOEFERMANN, Fritz, 1906- *Beitrage zum experimentellen Studium rheumatischer Gewebsveranderungen [Munster] 20p. 8? Bochum, H. Poppinghaus, 1934. HOEFFGEN, Anna, 1907- *Lympho- epitheliales Carcinom. 15p. 8? Wiirzb., R. Mayr, 1933. HOEFFKEN, Fritz, 1910- *Beitrag zur Kenntnis der Leichenveranderungen. 23p. 8? Rostock, G. Neumann, 1935. HOEFFKEN, Otto, 1909- *Bestehen Zusammenhange zwischen der Nahrung und der Abkauung der Zahne bei den Naturvolkern? 24p. 8? Lpz., A. Haudt, 1933. HOEFFKEN, Walter, 1907- *Der Ein- fluss lokaler Traumen auf die Zahne bei Natur- volkern [Leipzig] 16p. 8? Rheydt, O. Berger, 1933 HOEFFLER, Hella, 1905- *Auswertung von Harnextrakten auf Hypophysenvorderlap- pensubstanz [Freiburg] l3p. 8? Quaken- bruck, C. Trute, 1931. HOEFINGHOFF, Hans Jiirgen, ^lO- ^ber Tuberkulome des Gehirns [Munster] 36p. 8? Bottrop, W. Postberg, 1935. HOEFINGHOFF, Lotte, 1904- lnter- suchungen uber die Brauchbarkeit der Descoeud- resschen Tests fur die Beurteilung der cerebralen Entwicklung des Spielkindes [Berlin] 44p 8° Charlottenb., Gebr. Hoffmann, 1931 HOEFLER, ' Max, 1848- Deutsches Krankheitsnamen-Buch. xi, 922p. pl. 261/cm Munch., Piloty & Loehle, 1899. ---- Volksmedizinische Botanik der Ger- manen. 3 p. 1. 124p. 8? Wien, R. Ludwig, 1908 ,TTFT°rm>s,..Bd,*5' Q,,ellen & Forschung. Deut. Volkskundc (E. R. Blumml) HOEFLER, Otto, 1904- *Das Foramen coecum der Zahne und seine Beziehungen zur Karies. 24p. 8? Wurzb., K. Triltsch, 1930. HOEFLER, Wilma, 1909- *Fortschritte in Psychotechnik und Psychotherapie in der Zahnheilkunde. 23p. 8? Tiib. [n. pub.] 1934. HOEFLIGER, Hans, 1904- *Haarkleid und Haut des Wildschweines: Beitrag zur Ana- tomie von Sus scrofa L. und zum Domestikations- problem [Zurich] p.551-623. 8? Berl., J. Springer, 1931. Also Zschr. ges. Anat., 1. Abt., 1931, 95: HOEFT, Borge, 1906- *Ueber odontogen Herdinfektion mit besonderer Berucksichtigung der Provokationsmethode nach Mayer. 18p. 8? Tiib., A. Becht, 1935. HOEFT, Theo, 1901- *Ueber Miss- bildungen an der oberen Extremitat. 20p. 2 1. 8? Heidelb., P. Braus, 1929. HOEGER, Theodor, 1909- *Der Einfluss der Rontgenbestrahlung auf Asthma bronchiale. 19p. 21cm. Tub., Bolzle, 1938. HOEGGER, Dietrich. *Versuche liber Bak- teriophagenvermehrung in Ultrafiltraten [Basel] p.465-71. 23^cm. Wurzb., H. Stiirtz, 1939. Also Zschr. Hyg., 1939, 121: HOEGYES, Endre, 1847-1906. Aujeszky, A. [Commemoration of Endre Hogyes] Orvos- kepzes, 1932, 22: 60-81—Rejto, A. Ueber die htterarische Tatigkeit dps weiland Andreas Hogves. Acta otolar., Stockh., 1936. 24: 103-11. ------ [Literary activity of E. Hogyes] Orv. hetil.,' 1935, 79: 1175-7. HOEH, Berta, 1908- *Histologische Untersuchungen liber die Verteilung von Gold- priiparaten (Solganal) im tierischen Organismus [Munchen] 24p. 8? Tiib. [n. pub.l 1934. HOEH, Karl, 1906- *Vergiftungen durch Brandgase. 29p. 8? Wurzb. [n. pub.] 1931. HOEHN, Alice, 1908- *Rontgenstudien uber die Heilungsdauer von Extraktionswunden. 31p. pl. 8? Bonn, P. Kubens, 1933. HOEHN, Edgar, 1908- *Pharmakolo- gische und toxikologische Bedeutung der Insek- ten. 37p. 8? Wurzb., Gebr. Memminger, 1931. HOEHN, Georg, 1910- *Ueber Nekrosen, insbesondere Spontannekrosen der Haut und ihre Beziehungen zum vegetativen XTervensystem [Erlangen] 32p. 8? Kallmiinz, M. Lassleben, 1936. HOEHN, Kurt, 1906- *Wandlungen in der Frage der sogenannten Kropfrezidive [Wiirz- burg] 13p. 8? Borna-Lpz., R. Noske, 1933. HOEHN, Rolph, 1906- *Ueber Schadigun- gen von Pflanzen durch Gase, Dampfe, Staub und Rauch. 43p. 8? Wurzb., Gebr. Memminger, 1931. HOEHNE, Bernhard, 1909- *Steck- schiisse. 23p. 21cm. Munster, C. J. Fahle, 1937. HOEHNE, Hermann, 1871- For Festschrift see Arch. Gyn., Ber!., 1931, 146: portr. HOEHNE, Kurt, 1907- *Ueber die exspektative Behandlung des septischen Abortes. 15p. 8? Kiel, Schmidt & Klaunig, 1935. HOEHNE 736 HOELSCHER HOEHNE. Kurt, 1911- *Ueber Narkose-, Krampf- und Blutdruckwirkung einfacher or- ganischer Salze. 19p. 8? Tiib., Bolzle, 1937. HOEHNE, Ottomar, 1871-1932. (Jracert, O. Nekrolog. Arch. Gyn., Berl., 1932, 151: 1-15. AUr, Miinch. med. Wschr.. 1932, 79: 1327.—Stephan, S. Nekrolog Klin. Mbl. Ausrcnh., 1932, 89: 332-5.—Stoeckel, \V. Nekrolog. Zbl. Gyn., 1932, 56: 2162, portr. HOEHNE [Paul] Erich, 1907- *Die histo- chemische Lokalisation des sogenannten normalen Bleis in bleibenden menschlichen Zahnen ver- schiedener Altersstufen. lOp. 2 pl. 23cm. Lpz., A. Edelmann, 1936. HOEHNE, Walther, 1898- *Ein unklarer Fall von Polyneuritis bei Syphilis [Breslau] 17p. 8? Gorlitz, Wagenknecht & Endler, 1926. HOEHNE, Wolfgang, 1908- *Ueber 62 Sterilisationen der Wurzburger Frauenklinik von 1923 bis 1934 ohne Berucksichtigung der gesetz- lichen Sterilisationen [Wurzburg] 40p. 8? Ochsenfurt, Fritz & Rappert, 1937. HOEHNLE, Elisabeth, 1914- *Das Quecksilber; seine Wirkung und Bedeutung, hauptsachlich in der Zahnheilkunde. 33p. 22cm. Wurzb., R. Mayr, 1937. HOEHNLE, Max, 1912- *Rassen- und familienkundlicher Vergleich der iilteren Schiiler des Miinnerstadter Gymnasiums nach ihrem Wunsch katholischer Pfarrer oder etwas anderes zu werden. 27p. 22^cm. Wiirzb., K. Triltsch, 1936. HOEK, P. M.. 1857-1935. Plantenua-Hogcwind, J. C. [Obituary] Groene & witte kruis 1935, 31: 191, portr. HOEKSTRA, Rikstus Andries. *Hct gedrag van digitalis-glucosiden in het dierlijke organisme en de samenstelling van digilalis-preparaten [Utrecht] 129p. 8? Berl., F. C. W. Vogel, 1931. HOELDERLIN, Friedrich. 1770- Stemplinger, F. Fricdiich Holderlin; eine psychiatrische Studie zu Benedikt Lochmiillers Holderlin-Epos Brand im Tempel. Allg. Zschr. Psychiat, 1932, 97: 517.—Treichler, R. Die seelische Erkrankung Friedrich Holderlins in ihren Bezie- hungen :u scinem dichterischen Schaflen. Zschr. ges. Neur. Psychiat., 1936, 155: 40-144. HOELDERLIN, Heinz, 1911- *Knochen- mark und Blutbild beim sensibilisierten Tier. iv, p.l 18-39. 8? Tiib., Bolzle, 1938. Also Virchows Arch., 1938, 302: HOELL, Herbert, 1907- *Zur Pharmako- logie der Expektorantien (Einfluss verschiedener Substanzen auf die rhythmischen Bewegungen der Froschlunge) 18p. 2 1. 8? Halle [n. pub.] 1933 HOELL, Hermann, 1907- *Die Lach- gasnarkose in der modernen Zahnheilkunde [Erlangen] 36p. 8? Naumburg a. d. Saale, A. Rietz & Sohn, 1931. HOELL, Karl, 1901- Leitfaden fur das chemische Praktikum der Mediziner. 2 p. 1. 130p. illust. 8? Hannover, M. & H. Schaper, 1932 HOELLDOBLER, Karl, 1905- *Die Zir- beldrusc; ein inkretorisches Organ mit morpho- genetischer Bedeutung (Wurzburg] p.605-24. 8? Berl., J. Springer, 1926. Also Arch. Entwmech., 1926, 107: HOELLGER, Martin, 1909- *Ueber die Wirkung eines hochdispersen kolloidalen Schwcfel- priiparates auf den Kohlehydratstoffwechsel des Kaninchens. 15p. 8? Konigsb., J. Raabe, 1934. HOELSCHER, Giinter, 1907- *Heilungs- ergebnisse der traumatisehen Oberschenkelfrak- turen dargestellt an 110 in den Jahren 1919-28 in der Kieler chirurgischen Universitatsklinik be- handelten und 1930 naghuntersuchten Fallen [Kiel] 16p. 8? Rostock, E. W. Holz, 1932. HOELSCHER, Julius H., 1861 1926. Obituary. Proc. Inst. M. Chicago, 1926-27, 6: 169, portr. HOELSCHER, Wilhelm, 1901- *Ueber den Einfluss von Eisen auf die Methylenblauent- farbung. 23p. 8? Miinst. [n. pub.] 1933. HOELTGE, Artur, 1906- *Zur Behand- lung intraoraler Wunden mit Wundkegeln (Konoids) 27p. 8? Miinch., Haver. Druck, 1933 HOELTING, Josef, 1912- *Ueber Lues congenita bei Neugeborenen [Minister] 27p. 21cm. Berl., Fischer, 1938. HOELTKEMEIER, Hans, 1903- *Ueber das Vorkommen anderweitigcr Erscheinungen von Tuberkulose bei Tuberkuloderm. 25p. 8? Gott. [n. pub.] 1931. HOELZER, Ludwig, 1906- *Ueber Pan- kreascysten und ihre Diagnose. 64p. 8? Bonn, P. Kubens, 1932. HOELZL, Fritz. *Ueber die Entstehung von Kohlehydrat und Fett aus Eiweiss [Munchen] 15p. 8° Wurzb., R. Mayr, 1933. HOELZLE, Alfons, 1909- *Ueber die scarlatinose Erkrankung des Gehorganges [Wurz- burg] 14p. 21cm. Bottrop, W. Postberg, 1936. HOELZLE, Emil, 1908- *Ueber die Oberfiiichenspannung des Kiilberblutes [Mun- chen] 48p. 21cm. Quakenbruck, R. Kleinert, 1938. HOEN, Ernst, 1910- *Ein Fall von Bron- chitis plastica bei Lungen- und Lymphdriisen- tuberkulose; ein Beitrag zur Aetiologie der Bronchitis plastica. 25p. 22cm. Koln, J. Borowsky, 1936. HOEN, Nelly, 1905- *Zur Diagnose und Behandlung der Pylorusstenose im Sauglingsalter [Erlangen] 14p. 8? Kallmiinz, M. Lassleben, 1934. HOENE, Paul, 1899- *Allergie als Ursache abdomineller Krankheitsbilder. 29p. 8? Halle, O. Jung, 1932. HOENER, Alfons, 1903- *Ueber ein extramedullares Neurinom des Brustmarkes [Munster] 36p. 8? Quakenbruck, R. Kleinert, 1933. HOENIG, Josef, 1908- *Das Krank- heitsbild der Thromboendarteriitis obliterans pulmonalis. p.645-63. 23cm. [Bresl., n. pub., 1937] Also Deut. Arch. klin. Med., 1937, 180: HOENIG, Joseph, 1906- *Kritische Wiirdigung der Calziumtherapie unter besonderer Berucksichtigung der neueren Praparate [Miin- chen] 22p. 8? Ingolstadt [n. pub.] 1932. HOENIG, Kurt [Otto Karl] 1910- *Ueber die Bedeutung des Stellungsfaktors bei verschie- dener Gelenkbeanspruchung. p.87-104. 8? Jena [n. pub.] 1934. Also Zschr. Psychol. Physiol. Sinnesorg., 2 Abt., 1934, 65: HOENIG, Lucie, 1901- *Kasuistischer Beitrag zur doppelseitigen Ruptur des Muskels quadriceps femoris. 24p. 8! Konigsb., J. Raabe, 1928. HOENIG, Ottilie, 1906- *Klinische Analvse dentaler Neuralgien [Frankfurt] p. 1137-50. 8? Berl., J. Springer, 1931. Also Deut. Mschr'. Zahnh., 1931, 49: HOENIGHAUS, Josef, 1909- *Ueber die Wirkung von Natriumbromacetate bei peroraler Zufuhr [Munster] 15p. 22}4cm. Emsdetten, H. & J. Lechte, 1938. HOENLE, Konrad, 1910- *Ueber das Verhalten von foetalem und mutterlichem Ge- webe bei angewachsener Placenta und Blasen- mole. 15p. 8? Tub., Muller & Bass, 1937. HOENN 737 HOERDT HOENN, Gisela, 1914- *Ueber Zahn- und Kieferverhaltnisse bei Kropfkranken. 16p. 21cm. Wiirzb., Gebr. Memminger, 1936. HOENN, Walter, 1906- *Eine trau- matische Epithelcvste im Knochen. 14p. 2 pl. 8? Wiirzb., P. Scheiner, 1930. HOENSCH, Albert, 1907- *Die heutigen Sepsistheorien und die Berechtigung der fiir die Allgemein-Infektion gebrauchlichen Nomenklatur unter Berucksichtigung der Etymologie [Mar- burg] 32p. 8? Diisseld., G. H. Nolte, 1934. HOENSCHER, Hans, 1908- *Thrombose und Embolie; ihre Bedeutung in der gerichtlichen Medizin. 48p. 8? Bresl., K. Vater, 1934. HOEPER, Eduard, 1911- *Ein Verfahren zur beschleunigten Feststellung des Keimgehaltes in Wasser. 15p. 21cm. Freib. i. B., Bar & Bartosch, 1936. HOEPER, Ursula, 1912- *Stoffwechsel- untersuchungen bei chronischer Kohlenoxyd- vergiftung [Munster] 15p. 21cm. Bottrop, W. Postberg, 1936. HOEPFEL, Wilhelm, 1908- *Ueber Zu- sammenhange zwischen Nierenerkrankungen und Aphthenbildung in der Mundhohle [Wiirzburg] 20p. 8? Ochsenfurt, Fritz & Rappert, 1931. HOEPFNER, Rudolf [Karl Albert] 1910- *Was leistet die Vasoresektion zur Verhiitung einer Epididymitis bei Prostatahvpertrophie? 36p. 8? Lpz., Gebr. Gerhardt, 1935. HOEPKE, Hermann [Leonhard Theodor August] 1889- Das Muskelspiel des Men- schen. 83p. illust. 8? Jena, G. Fischer, 1936. See also Frey, M. von, Hoepke. H. [et al.] Physiologie der Haut, Chemie [&c] 658p. 8? Berl., 1929. HOEPLER, Erwein, 1868- , & SCHILDER, P. Suggestion und Straf rechts wissenschaft. 89p. 8? Wien, Holder, 1926. Forms H. 3-4, Abh. jurist, med. Grenzgeb. HOEPNER, Ursula, 1904- " *Die chi- rurgische Behandlung der Gallenblasen- und Gallengangserkrankungen in Beziehung zu Leber und Kreislauf. 43p. 8? Freib. i. B., Mors & Singler, 1932. HOEPPING [Georg] Rudolf, 1912- *Bei- trag zur Kenntnis des plazentaren Kalkstoff- wechsels bei Schaf, Rind und Schwein. p. 123-54. 8? Lpz., E. Hedrich, 1937. Also Morph. Jahrb., 1937, 79: HOEPPLI, H. F., HSU, H. F., & WU, H. W. Helminthologische Beitrage aus Fukien und Chekiang. 44p. 7 pl. 8? Lpz., J. A. Barth, 1929. Forms Beih. 1, v.33, Arch. Schiffs Tropenhyg. HOEPPLI, Reinhard, 1893- Ueber Be- ziehungen zwischen dem biologischen Verhalten parasitischer Nematoden und histologischen Reaktionen des Wirbeltierkorpers. 88p. pl. 8? Lpz., J. A. Barth. 1927. Forms Beih. 3, v.31, Arch. Schiffs Tropenhyg. HOEPS, Hubert, 1907- *Poliomyelitis anterior acuta adultorum. 47p. 8? Miinst. [n. pub.] 1935. HOERDEMANN, Carola, 1911- *Spat- folgen einer Granatsplitterverletzung. 23p. 21cm. Heidelb., H. Fahrer, 1936. HOERDEMANN, Robert. *Ein Fall von Teratom der Schilddrusengegend. p. 245-58. 8? [Gott., n. pub.] 1925. Also Frankf. Zechr. Path., 1925, 32: HOERDER, Henny, 1891- *Intraab- dominelle Blutungen aus den Generations- organen mit Ausschluss der intra- und extra- uterinen Schwangerschaft [Berlin] 32p. 8: Charlottenb., Gebr. Hoffmann, 1932. 227475—vol. 7, 4th sekibs----47 HOERDT, Eduard, 1899- *Welchen Einfluss hat eine langerdauernde Amenorrhoe auf die generativen Funktionen der weiblichen Genitalorgane? [Konigsberg] 22p. 8? Berl Westkreuz, 1937. HOEREN [Eugen] Ludwig [Wolfgang] 1910- *Untersuchungen uber die quantitative Bestim- mung von Morphin in kleinen Mengen. 15n 23^cm. Kiel, A. C. Ehlers, 1937. HOERGER, Kurt, 1907- *Fernwirkun- gen in der Gewebskultur durch Vitamin D und vitaminhaltige Oele [Tubingen] 19p. 8? Schramberg, Gatzer & Hahn, 1933. HOERHAMMER, Ludwig. See Schlemmer, F., & Horhammer, L. Die pharma- kognostische Teeanalyse. 135p. 32cm. Berl., 1939. HOERHOLD, Kurt [Karl] *Der Verlauf des Zwischenstiickes in 2000 Elektrokardiogrammen 24p. 8? Halle, E. Klinz, 1935. HOERIG, Hans, 1895- *Zur Trennung der saurefesten Saprophyten von den Tuberkel- bazillen mittels Antiformin [Leipzig] 20p 8? Dresd. [n. pub.] 1923. HOERING [Hans] Heinz, 1909- *Die epithelialen Tumoren der Harnblase (65 Falle aus der Chirurgischen Universitatsklinik zu Leipzig) 40p. 8? Bleicherode, C. Nieft, 1935. HOERING, Kurt, 1913- *Liegt dem Herpes simplex eine Erkrankung der nervosen Centralorgane zu Grunde? 18p. 8? Tiib., A Becht 1937 HOERLEIN, Hfeinrich] ROEHL, W. [et al.] Neue synthetische Arzneistoffe gegen Malaria 35p. 8? Lpz., J. A. Barth, 1926. Forms Beih. 3, v.30. Arch. Schiffs Tropenhyg. HOERMANN, Ernst, 1910- *Verglei- chende experimentelle Untersuchungen iiber das Schicksal pathogener und apathogener Bakterien in Schnittwunden der Haut und der Zungen- schleimhaut [Munchen] 18p. 8? Wiirzb., R. Mayr, 1934. HOERMANN, Johannes, 1845-1926. Salzmann. Nekrolog. Apothekerzeitung, 1926, 41: 874. HOERMANN, Joseph, 1898- *Ueber einen Fall von Tubenusur. 23p. 8? Munch. [n. pub.] 1926. HOERMLE, Egon, 1908- *Ein Beitrag zum zahnarztlichen Gussverfahren. 28p. 8? Tub., C. Guide [1934] HOERNECKE, Joachim, 1907- *Ueber therapeutische Beeinflussung des Kampfgas- Lungenodems durch Mineralsalze. 15p. 8? Konigsb., J. Raabe, 1932. HOERNEMANN, Johann, 1909- *Sto- matitis haemorrhagica. 39p. 8? Bonn, L. Neuendorff, 1934. HOERNER, Otto, 1905- *Ueber die Tuberkulose des Mittelohrs unter spezieller Berucksichtigung der Prognose operierter Mittel- ohrtuberkulose bei Kindern. 23p. 8? Wiirzb., Gebr. Memminger, 1931. HOERNI, Konrad. *Die Zangengeburten der zurcherischen Universitats Frauenklinik in den Jahren 1888-1907 [Zurich] 61p. 8? Andel- fingen, W. Hepting, 1909. HOERNSTEIN, Franz, 1912- *Ueber die Entfernung von Dickdarmpolypen [Heidel- berg] 29p. 22cm. Wurzb., R. Mayr, 1938. HOEROLDT, Heinz, 1908- *Die zahn- iirztliche Versorgung der Hilfsbediirftigen [Leip- zig] 35p. 8? Zeulenroda, A. Oberreuter, 1934. HOERSEN, Wilhelm, 1904- *Einige seltenere Falle aus dem Gebiet der Adenomyosis beziehungsweise Endometriosis, 2 Nabeladenome HOERSEN 738 HOET und 3 Cervixpolypen. 16p. 8? Wiirzb., K. Roll, 1933. HOERSTER, Karl Wilhelm, 1911- *Ueber die Wirkung von Blattgemiise als Nahrungs-N- Trager auf die Lage der Harnquotienten C:N und Vacat-O: N am Beispiel des Griinkohls mit einer Einleitung iiber den Vegetarismus in der Antike. 24p. 24cm. Berl., Rinck, 1938. HOERTLING, Felix, 1908- * Ueber die gutartigen Stutzsubstanzgeschwulste des Magens, unter besonderer Berucksichtigung der cystischen Magenmyome [Tubingen] 32p. 8? Zuffen- hausen, Henke], 1935. HOESCH, K[urt] Die Nebenschilddriisen- Epilepsie. 135p. 8? Berl., S. Karger, 1937. Forms H. 80, Abh. Neur. Psychiat. HOESER, Arno, 1897- *Zahnheilkunde bei Johann Jessenius von Jessen (auch Jessinsky) (1566-1621) 27p. 8? Lpz., E. Lehmann, 1924. HOESL, Josef. *Ueber Unterschiede in der tryptischen und peptischen Spaltung des Caseins, Paracaseins und des Paracaseinkalkes aus Kuh- und Ziegenmilch. 29p. 8? [Bern] F. Jumpertz, 1910. HOESL, Max, 1907- *Ueber Marubiin. 22p. 8! Wurzb., K. Triltsch, 1936. HOESL, Michael. *Stand der Ostitis fibrosa bis 1934 mit einem Beitrag [Munchen] 48p. 2 pl. 22cm. Oberviechtach, I. Forstner, 1937. HOESLI, Henri, 1906- *Troubles fonc- tionnels et lesions de l'oesophage dans la sclero- dermic. 107p. 8? Par., Jouve & cie, 1937. HOESS, Hanns, 1903- *Ueber Poly- myositis (Dermatomyositis) [Munchen] 37p. 8? Coburg [n. pub.] 1930. HOESS, Max, 1908- *Defekte des Gaumens (Perforationen) unter besonderer Be- riicksichtigung der durch Gummisauger beding- ten Schadigungen [Munchen] 35p. 8? Giinz- burg [n. pub.] 1934. HOESSLER, Georg, 1909- *Extraorale Entfernung von Zahnen [Munchen] 14p. 8? Wiirzb., R. Mayr, 1935. HOESSLER, Hans, 1912- *Ueber die Ausscheidung subkutan injicierter Zuckerlosun- gen bei Froschlurchen [Leipzig] 20p. 22cm. Wiirzb., R. Mayr, 1936. HOESSLIN, Heinrich von, 1878- Das Sputum, x, 398p. 8? Berl., J. Springer, 1921. Also 2. Aufl. x, 485p. 1926. ---- Daten und Tabellen fiir den Praktiker. iv, 98p. 12? Lpz., G. Thieme, 1927. ---- Vorlesungen iiber Erkrankungen des Respirationssytems. 150p. 8? Lpz., G. Thieme, 1935. ---- & MUELLER, Franz. Theoretische und klinische Pharmakologie; ein Lehrbuch fiir Studierende und Aerzte. 4. Aufl. x, 245p. 8° Lpz., G. Thieme, 1933. HOESSLIN, Kunz von. *Der Wert der Hysterosalpingographie zur Beurteilung der Fer- tility [Munchen] 24p. 8? Augsb., K. Sporer, 1932 HOESSLIN, Rudolf von, 1858-1936. Ueber multiple Sklerose; exogene Aetiologie, Patho- genese und Verlauf. l09p. 8? Miinch., J. F. Lehmann, 1934. For biography see Munch, med. Wschr., 1928, 75: 788-90- 1936, 83: 319, portr. (F. Muller) HOESTEREY, Karl Robert, 1909- *Ueber die Wirkung der Antipyretika auf den Phosphat- stoffwechsel [Miinster] 19p. 8? Werne- Lippe, F. Grube, 1933. HOET, Joseph Pierre, 1899- AUBER- TIN, E. [et al.] Les indications therapeutiques de l'insuline en dehors du diabete. 2 p. 1. 217p 25^cm. Par.; Masson & cie, 1930 Forms pt 3, Rapp. Congr. fr. med., 1930, 21. Sess. HOETTE, Alfons, 1912- *Die Schulzahn- pflege im Kreise Brilon unter besonderer Be- rucksichtigung der sozialen Verhaltnisse [Mun- ster] 29p. 21cm. Bigge-Ruhr, Josefs, 1937. HOETTE, Fritz, 1901- *Ueber die Wirkung des Kampferdampfes. lOp. 8? Gies- sen, A. Klein, 1926. HOETZ Raddatz, Guillermina. *Tcst de Rotter y su utilidad en la clfnica dental [Chile] 32p. 26^cm. Santiago, Talleres Graficos Artuffo, 1938. HOEVE, Jan van der, 1878- De tegen- woordige stand der oogheelkunde. 39p. Sa Leiden, A. W. Sijthoff, 1919. HOEVEL, H., 1864-1937. Grosz, K. Nekrolog. Wien. klin. Wschr., 1937, 50: 547. HOEVELMANN, Otto, 1900- *Ueber die lokale Anwendung von Jod-Tinktur bei Keratitis superficialis punctata. 12p. 2 1. 8? Wiirzb [n. pub.] 1930. HOEVEN, J[an] van der, 1863- *Over de zoogenaamde Epispadie bij de vrouw. 5-Jp. pl. 23cm. Leiden, P. Somerwil, 1889. HOEVEN, P[ieter] C[ornelis] Tfobias] van der, 1870- *De aetiologie der eclampsie. 216p. 23y2cm. Leiden, E. J. Brill, 1896. ---- Ziekte-oorzaken in het leven voor de geboorte. 35p. 8? Leiden, E. J. Brill, 1919. ---- Pathologie der zwangerschap. 2. Druk 2v. viii, 150p.; vii, 367p. 8? Zundert, W. Vorsselman, 1921-22. For portrait see Geneesk. gids, 1939, 17: No. 28. ---- & GORTER, E. Physiologie van zwan- gerschap, baring en kraambed; physiologie van den pasgeborene. 2. Druk. viii, 242p. pl. tab. 8? Zundert, W. Vorsselman, 1924. HOEVENER, Paul, 1902- *Ueber Zuk- kerschwund im Stauungsblut. 24p. 8? Kiel, Schmidt & Klaunig, 1926. HOEVERMANN, Reinhard, 1912- tier- experimentelle Untersuchungen der Wirkung des Vitamins B2, des Glutathions sowie des beide enthaltenden Praparates G-2-B auf die keim- feindliche Kraft des Blutes und die Hamato- poese. 23p. 22cm. Marb., H. Bauer, 1937. HOEXBROE, Hans Wilhelm, 1908- *Ueber die natiirlichen Schutz- und Wehr- krafte der Zahne und des Korpers gegen die Zahnkaries und die Frage der Moglichkeit ihrer Steigerung. 15p. 8? Berl, Buchholz & Weiss- wange, 1935. HOEXTER, Siegfried, 1899- ♦Erfah- rungen iiber die intravenose Indigokarminprobe zur Funktionsprufung der Nieren [Frankfurt] 20p. 8? Marb., Bauer, 1926. HOF, Erwin. Die Operation ohne Messer; Lehrschrift fiir Aerzte und gebildete Laien iiber das Fasten, das einzige wirkliche Naturheil- mittel welches wir besitzen. 125 [l]p. 19>^cm. Lorch-Wurttemb., K. Rohm [1937] HOFACKER, Peter, 1904- *Ueber Klein- hirnbriickenwinkeltumoren [Halle] 23p. 8? Borna, R. Noske, 1929. HOFBAUER, Arnold, 1909- *Beitrage zur Toxikologie des Aethylenoxyds und der Glykole. 29p. 8? Wurzb. [n. pub.] 1933. HOFBAUER, Ludwig, 1873- Atmungs- Pathologie und -Therapie. xii, 336p. 8? Berl., J. Springer, 1921. ---- Asthma, vii, 156p. 8? Wien, J. Springer, 1Q28. HOFBAUER 739 HOFF HOFBAUER, Ludwig, 1880- ■♦Unter- suchungen iiber das Vorkommen von Leukozyten und anderen Zellen im Harne gesunder Haus- siiugetiere. 26p. 8? [Lpz., n. pub.] 1925. HOFE, Paul von, 1900- *Ein Beitrag zur Kenntnis der Darier'schen Krankheit. 26p. 8? Berl., Gebr. Hoffmann, 1934. HOFEN, Richard von, 1908- *Die Abbindungszeiten, Druckfestigkeit und Stoff- festigkeit von Zink- und Aluminiumphosphatze- menten. 24p. 8? Tiib., E. Gobel, 1931. HOFER, Beatrice, 1904- Contributions a l'etude de la pathogenie de l'angine de poitrine et ses relations avec les syndromes angiospas- modiques peripheriques. 48p. 8? Par., Impr. Studio, 1935. HOFER, Eberhard, 1912- *Kasuisti- scher Beitrag zu den Gaumengeschwiilsten [Munster] 23p. 21cm. Quakenbruck, R. Kleinert, 1936. HOFER, Elfriede, 1911- lntersu- chungen iiber die physikalischen und chemischen Eigenschaften eines neuen Gussporzellans [Frei- burg] 33p. 22cm. Stalluponen, H. Klutke, 1936. HOFER, Friedrich. *Ueber das Auftreten von Aminosauren im Blut und im Urin bei Intoxi- kationen mit Lebergiften (Tierversuche) 36p. [Munchen] 8? [n. pl., 192.] Typewritten. HOFER, Fritz, 1908- *Ein Fall von Bindehauttuberkulose; Beitrag zur Klinik der Btndehauttuberkulose. 25p. 8? Konigsb., J. Raabe, 1936. HOFER, Georg, 1901- *Der Zahnarzt als Sachverstandiger. 40p. 8? Erlangen, O. Mauser, 1931. HOFER, Hans Heinrich, 1906- *Erfolge und Misserfolge der doppelseitigen Pneumo- thoraxbehandlung in der doppelseitigen Lungen- tuberkulose [Konigsberg], 19p. 21cm. Allen- stein, W. E. Harich, 1938. HOFER, Heinrich, 1902- *Die Halb- krone. 23p. 8? Heidelb., P. Braus, 1928. HOFER, Helmut, 1899- *Ueber trau- matische Appendizitis. 39p. 8? Berl., E. Ebering, 1929. HOFER, Karl. *Ueber Kolisepsis; ein kasui- stischer Beitrag [Zurich] 15p. 8? Basel, B. Schwabe & co., 1926. Also Schweiz. med. Wschr., 1926, 56: HOFER, Rudolf [Alfons] 1899- *Ueber die Wirkung von Gasgemischen (Potenzierung von Gaswirkungen) [Wurzburg] 23p. 8? [Lpz., Breitkopf & Hartel] 1925. Also Arch. exp. Path., Lpz., 1926, 111: 183-205. HOFER von Lobenstein, Maximilian, 1901- *Beitrag zur Divertikelbildung am Processus vermiformis. 38p. 8? Marb., R. Friedrich, 1928. HOFF, August, 1899- *Ueber den Gehalt des arteriellen und venosen Blutes an anor- ganischer Phosphorsaure [Giessen] p. 195-9. 8? Berl., J. Springer, 1929. Also Biochem. Zschr., 1929, 209: HOFF, Charles A. See Whitehead, Clayton S., & Hoff, Charles A. Ethical sex relations [&c] 336; 303p. 8? Chic, 1926. ------ The same. 338p.; 303p. illust. 20cm. Chic, 1928. HOFF, Ebbe C, & HOFF, Phebe M. The life and times of Richard Lower, physiologist and physician, 1631-1691. p.517-35. 8? [n. p., n. pub.] 1936. HOFF, Ferdinand, 1896- Unspezifische Therapie und naturliche Abwehvorgange. iv, 123p. 8? Berl., J. Springer, 1930. • a Pas vegetative Nervensystem und die innere Sekretion. p.380-453. 8? Jena, 1935. Jena! 1935 SP6Z' PEth' Physio1' (Becher. Bohnenkamp) HOFF, Hans. Die zentrale Abstimmung der Sehsphare. 96p. 8? Berl., S. Karger, 1930. Forms H. 54, Abh. Neur. Psychiat. J ~T~* & SCHILDER, Paul. Die Lagereflexe des Menschen; klinische Untersuchungen iiber Haltungs- und Stellreflexe und verwandte Pha- 1927ene' 2 P' L 182P' 8? WieD' J' SPringer' HOFF, Hans & SCHOENBAUER, Leopold. Hirnchirurgie; Erfahrungen und Resultate. 472p. illust. 8? Lpz., F. Deuticke, 1933. HOFF, Hebbel E. Galvani and the pre- Galvanian electrophysiologists. p. 157-72. 8° [n. p., n. pub.] 1936. HOFF, Heinrich [Richard Walter] 1911- *Ueber Zahnfrakturen [Leipzig] 20p. 8° Wiirzb., R. Mayr, 1935. HOFF, Herbert. See Blond, Kasper, & Hoff, Herbert. Das Hiimorrhoidal- Ieiden. 121p. 8? Lpz., 1936. HOFF, Jacobus Hendricus van't, 1852-1911. Dix annees dans l'histoire d'une theorie. 102p. 8? Rotterdam, P. M. Bazendijk, 1887. ---- Ueber die Theorie der Losungen. 30p. 8? Stuttg., F. Enke, 1900. Forms H., 5. Bd, Samml. chem. & chem. techn. Vortrage. HOFF, Johannes, 1912- *Ueber den heutigen Standpunkt der Unfallheilkunde in der Frage: Erkaltung und Wurmfortsatzentziindung [Munchen] 20p. 22cm. Diisseld., G. H. Nolte, 1937. HOFF, John van Rensselaer, 1848-1920. Report on the military sanitation of the Russian Armies in the Far East, 1905. 2 p. 1. 269 numb. 1. photogr. 33cm. Wash., 1905. Typewritten. ---- Resume" of the history of the Medical Department of the U. S. Army from 1775 to the beginning of the Spanish-American War. 72 1. 4? [Wash.] 1916. Typewritten. For biography see Mil. Surgeon, 1933, 73: 98-100 (M. W. Ireland) See also Hoff, J. Van R. Military record of Col. John Van Rensselaer Hoff, Medical Corps, U. S. A., retired 1872-1918 [Manuscript] 19 1. fol. [n. p., n. d.] Also United States Army Medical Center. The presentation of the portraits of Major General William Crawford Gorgas, Brigadier General James Madison Kennedy, Colonel John Van Rensselaer Hoff, to the Army Medical Center, Memorial Day, 1933. 8 1. 8? Wash., 1933. For portrait (photograph of the portrait by Bernhard God- win) see the presentation of the portraits [&c] 1933. Also portrait (photograph of a painting) see Collection in library. HOFF, Klaus, 1909- *Ueber die Bedeu- tung der Mucin-Reaktion im Speichel fiir. die gerichtliche Medizin. 15p. 8? Kiel, R. Eggert, 1934. HOFF, Marcel, 1911-- *Les raies trans- versales des os [Lyon] 50p. pl. 8? Bourg, Berthod, 1935. HOFF, Paul R. See Huff, W. C, & Hoff, P. R. Diversion terraces and con- tour strip-cropping. 35p. 23cm. Ithaca, 1941. HOFF, Peder A., 1874-1927. Obituary. Minnesota M., 1927, 10: 613. HOFF, Rulemann von, 1884- *Verglei- chende Untersuchungen uber Hamoglobin-Ge- halt, Erythrocyten-Volumen und Erythrocyten- Zahl (Beitrag zur Bewertung des Bonniger'schen Blutkorperchen-Volummeters) 20p. 8? Ro- stock, Adlers Erben, 1918. HOFF, Werner, 1908- *Die Bedeutung der Schulzahnpflege in Deutschland fiir die HOFF Volksgesundheit [Breslau] 38p. 8? Baruth- Berl., J. Siirchen, 1932. HOFFA, Albert, 1859-1908. Rosenfeld, L. [Biography] Zschr. orthop. Chir., 1933, 59: 165-75.—Sehanz, A. [Biography] Ibid., 162-4, portr. ----& GRASHEY, Rudolf. Atlas und Grund- riss der Verbande; fiir Studierende und Aerzte. 7. Aufl. viii, 188p. 12? Munch., J. F. Lehmann, 1922. Forms Bd 13, Lehmann's Med. Handatlanten. HOFFBERG, Karl Fredrik, 1729-90. Portrait. In Portr. Sven. lak. apotek. (Sjoberg, N.) Stockh., 1910, 52. HOFFER, Henriette, 1885- ♦Contribu- tion k l'etude de la determination de l'acuite auditive; 6tude du procede' collectif du Dr Simon pour mesurer l'acuite auditive des 6coliers. 63p. 8? Par., M. Vigne, 1926. See also Parrel, Gerard de, & Holier, Henriette. Les enfants qu'il faut readapter. 286p. 8? Par., 1935. ---- & PARREL, G. de. La lecture sur le- levres chez les sourds; reeducation psycho? visuelle. ix, 193p. 50 illust. 8? Par., G. Doin & cie, 1932. HOFFHEINZ, Siegfried, 1892- Die Luft- und Fettembolie. xii, 259p. illust. 8? Stuttg., F. Enke, 1933. .- Forms Bd 55., Neue deut. Chir. (P. von Bruns) HOFFLIN-KARWATZKI, Charles Christian. See Bucher-Triimpler, O. H., & Hofnin-Karwatzki, C. C. Die biologische Reaktion. 263p. 26>^cm. Bern, 1939. HOFFMAN, A. H. Story of how I cured my asthma or gas speels with simple home remedies. 7p. 18? Monrovia, Calif., the Author, 1935. HOFFMAN, Anna C. Young mother's tokol- ogy; 20. century book for mothers and nurses. 148p. 8? Chic, Midland med. pub. co., 1902. HOFFMAN, Anton, 1739-82. [Portrait] In Portr. Sven. liik. apotek. (Sjoberg, N.) Stockh., 1910, 52. HOFFMAN, C. H. Essentials of pathology, general and special. 149p. 8? Kirksville, Mo., J. F. Janisch supply house [190?] HOFFMAN, Donald C, 1899-1938. [Obituary] Abstr. Proc. Ass. Life Insur. M. Dir. America, 1938, 25: 290. HOFFMAN, Frederick Ludwig, 1865- [Clippings on fires or conflagrations] 2v. [v. p.] sm. 4? 1850-1918. ---- [Clippings on railroad accidents] 2v. [v. p.] sm. 4? 1874-1918. ---- [Clippings on drowning and marine disasters] 163p. sm. 4? 1883-1920. ---- [Clippings on bicycle accidents] 93p. sm. 4? 1896. ---- [Clippings on firearms and fourth of July accidents] 105p. sm. 4? 1896. ---- [Clippings on street railway accidents] 2v. [v. p.] sm. 4? 1896-1913. ---- [Clippings on electric, elevated or sub- way accidents] 76p. sm. 4? 1898. ---- [Clippings on explosions] 73p. sm. 4? 1898. ---- [Clippings on automobile accidents] 4v. sm. 4? 1899-1920. ---- [Clippings on carriage or wagon acci- dents] 44p. sm. 4? 1900. ---- [Clippings on traffic accidents] 56p. sm. 4? 1908. ---- More facts and fallacies of compulsory health insurance. 180p. 23cm. [Newark, Prudential press, 1919] ---- Cancer and civilization; an addres read before the Belgian National Cancer Congress, Brussels, Nov. 18-19, 1923. 35p. 23cm. [Newark. N. J., Prudential Insur. co. 1923] HOFFMAN ---- Southern health and welfare. 15p. 8? Newark, N. J. [Prudential press] 1925. ---- Cancer among North American Indians; the health progress of the North American Indian; the Indian as a life insurance risk. 85p. 8? [Newark, N. Y., Prudential press, 1928] ---- Some problems of longevity, x, 180p 8? Chic, Spectator co., 1928. ---- Suicide problems. 270p. 8? Newark, N. J., Prudential press, 1928. ---- Malaria in Mississippi and adjacent states. 15p. 8? [n. p.] Prudential press, 1932. ---- Introduction to discussion on geographi- cal distribution of cancer in Spain; the cancer of 1932. p. 1275-1362. 8? Madr. [Prudential press] 1933. ---- Malaria in Virginia, North Carolina and South Carolina. 30p. 8? [Newark, N. J.] Prudential press, 1933. ---- The appendicitis record for 1933. 4p. 4? [N. Y., 1934] Repr. from Spectator, 1924. ---- The diabetes record of 1933. 4p. 4? [n. p.] 1934. Repr. from Spectator, 1934. ---- San Francisco Cancer Survey: 9. and final report. 147p. 8? Newark, N. J., Pru- dential Insur. co., 1934. ---- The known duration of cancer. 7p. 8? B. Air. [n. pub.] 1935. ---- Cancer in India, Persia and Ceylon. 25p. 8? Calc [n. pub.] 1936. ---- Cancer and diet, with facts and observa- tions on related subjects, xx, 767p. diagrs. X'.' Bait., Williams & Wilkins co., 1937. ---- Compulsory health insurance and dis- ease control. 38p. incl. portr. 16^cm. N. Y., Med. Soc State New York [1937] ---- Deaths from lead poisoning; 69. Congr. 2. Sess. House Doc. No. 489. iii, 45, v, p. 8? Wash., Gov. Print. Off., 1927. Forms No. 426, Bull. U. S. Bur. Lab. Stat. Indust. Accid. k Hyg. Ser. For portrait see In his Compulsory health insurance and disease control, N. Y. [1937] front. HOFFMAN, George M[arwood] 1903- *The difficulty of diagnosis of appendicitis in children [Marquette Univ.] 17p. 4? Mil- waukee, Wis., 1930. Typewritten. HOFFMAN, Herbert. Esoteric osteopathy. 32p. 8? Phila., The Author, 1908. HOFFMAN, Katherine. A model hospital. p.487-96. illust. 25cm. [N. Y. [n. pub.] 1900] HOFFMAN, K. B., & Ultzmann, R. Guide to the examination of urine; with special reference to the diseases of the urinary apparatus. 2. ed. 251p. 8? Cincin., Woodruff, Cox & co., 1886. HOFFMAN, Max. Die Lehre vom plotz- lichen Tod in Lancisis Werk De subitaneis mortibus. 62p. 8? Berl., E. Ebering, 1935. Forms H. No. 6, Abh. Gesch. Med. Naturwiss. HOFFMAN, Philip, 1871-1939. Obituary. J. Am. M. Ass., 1939, 113: 161. HOFFMAN, William Samuel, 1899- Pho- telometric clinical chemistry, xiv, 254p. illust. 2 pl. diagr. 21cm. N. Y., W. Morrow & co., 1941. HOFFMANN, A[lfons] 1905- *Ueber den Einfluss der Rontgenologie auf die Entwicklung der Zahnheilkunde. 35p. 8? Bonn, P. Kubens, 1930. HOFFMANN, Alfred, 1906- *Ueber en- terale und perorale Insulinwirkung [Erlangen] 31p. 21cm. Kallmiinz, M. Lassleben, 1935. HOFFMANN 741 HOFFMANN HOFFMANN, Anna, 1899- *Beitrag zur chirurgischen Behandlung der Pleuratuberculose. 20p. 8? Berlin, Gebr. Hoffmann, 1933. HOFFMANN, August, 1862-1929. Krank- heiten der Kreislaufsorgane. 112p. 4 pl. 8? Lpz., G. Thieme, 1923. Forms H. 7, Diagr. & ther. Irrtiim. [&c] Innere Med. ----Krankheiten der Brustorgane und des Kreislaufs. p.21-174. 8? Dresd., 1929. In Prakt. Differentialdiagn. (Honigmann) Dresd. 1929, 1: HOFFMANN, Auguste, 1902- *Stoff- wechselregulationen: zur Physiologie des Fettge- webes und der Fettablagerung [Halle] p.728- 46. 8? Berl., J. Springer, 1927. Also Arch. ges. Physiol., 1927, 217: ---- *Der Einfluss des Trainings auf die Skeletmuskulatur [Habilitationsschrift; Berlin] p.595-622. 23^cm. Lpz. [n. pub.] 1938. Also Zschr. mikr. anat. Forsch., 1938, 43: HOFFMANN, Bruno, 1891- *Ueber einen Todesfall an Herzdekompensation mit Aneurysma des Ductus Botalli. 20p. 8? BerL, B. Vergin, 1934. HOFFMANN, Bruno, 1912- *Diagno- stische Verwertbarkeit von Blutsenkungsver- fahren am Leichenblut [Halle] 36p. 21cm. Bleichenrode, C. Nieft, 1938. HOFFMANN, Carl Albin, 1879- *Ex- perimentelle Untersuchungen iiber die Wiikung des Collargols auf Leukocyten und Opsonine. 21p. 8? Lpz., B. Georgi, 1908. HOFFMANN, Charles. Contribution a l'etude de la fixation de l'anhydride antimonique par les acides tartrique, malique et oxalique [Fac. Pharm.] 4 p. 1. p.[ll]-49. incl. tab. diagr. 24cm. Strasb., Impr. C. Roch, 1935. HOFFMANN, Christoph Ludwig, 1721-1807. For biography see: Gerbracht, M. *Aus den hinterlassenen Briefen des Mtinsteraner Arztes Christoph Ludwig Hoffmann [Munster] 75p. 21cm. Lengerich, 1938. Twenhoven, M. *Veroffentlichungen aus Christoph Ludwig Hoffmanns schriftlichem Nach- lass [Munster] 91p. 8? Lengerich [1936] HOFFMANN, Curt, 1898- Dei Atmung der Meeresalgen und ihre Beziehung zum Salz- gehalt [Habilitationsschrift; Kiel] p.214-68. 8? Lpz., Gebr. Borntraeger, 1929. Also Jahrb. wiss. Bot., 71: HOFFMANN, Dietrich, 1909- ♦Beob- achtungen iiber das Verhalten des weissen Blutbildes bei pernicibser Anaemie in der Zeit vor und wahrend der Leberbehandlung. 20p. 22cm. Bresl. [n. pub.] 1935. HOFFMANN, Eberhard, 1909- ♦Klini- sche Untersuchungen iiber die lokale Gefass- wirkung des 2%igen Pantokains in der Rhinolo- gie. 32p. tab. 8? Bresl., A. Schreiber, 1933. HOFFMANN, Edmund, 1909- *Rasse und Karies. 34p. 22cm. Bonn, H. Trapp, 1936. HOFFMANN, Eleonore, 1908- *Ein Beitrag zur Frage der Fragmentatio myocardii [Breslau] 33p. 8? Ohlau, H. Eschenhagen, 1935. HOFFMANN, Elisabeth, 1913- *Ueber die Cholesterase im Serum Gesunder und Kran- ker; ihre Inaktivierung. 33p. 20>^cm. Bonn, H. Trapp, 1938. HOFFMANN, Erhard, 1901- *Ein in Heilung ausgegangener Fall von oraler Sepsis, bei dem ein bisher unbeschriebener Kapsel- bazillus aus dem Blut geziichtet wurde [Berlin] 25p. 2 pl. 8? Charlottenb., Gebr. Hoffmann, 1928. HOFFMANN, Erich, 1868- Die Be- handlung der Haut- und Geschlechtskrankheiten. 149p. 8. Bonn, A. Marcus & E. Weber, 1919. —— [The same] Die Behandlung der Haut- und Geschlechtskrankheiten mit kurzer Diag- nostik. 5. Aufl. vi, 318p. 8? Berl., A. Marcus & E. Weber, 1930. Also 6. Aufl. xii, 347p. illust. 1937. y „ 7~ Die angeborene Syphilis im Lichte 30jahnger Spirochaten- und 25jahriger Sal- varsanforschung. 46p. 3 pl. 8? Berl . S Karger, 1936. Forms H. 40, Abh. Kinderh. For Festschrift see Derm. Zschr., 1928, 53: portr See also Lutz, W. Erich Hoffmann zum 70. Geburtstag. Derm. Zschr., 1938, 77: 185.—Verzeichnis der Arbeiten von Erich Hoffmann. Ibid., 234-50. HOFFMANN, Erich, 1903- *Schaden bei und nach kieferorthopadischen Massnahmen [Leipzig] 54p. 8? Wilkau, F. K. Zschiesche, 1935. HOFFMANN, Erich, 1909- *Zur phar- makologischen Beeinflussung der Froschpupille [Tubingen] 15p. 8? Schramb., Gatzer & Hahn, 1936. HOFFMANN [Ernst Heinrich] Kurt, 1906- *Ueber einen Fall von intrathorakalem Ganglio- neurom des linken Nervus sympathicus mit starker Einengung des Thoraxraumes. 31p. 20Hcm. Marb., J. Hamel, 1937. HOFFMANN, Ferdinand. Sittliche Entartung und Geburtenschwund. 6. Aufl. 87p. 25cm. Munch., J. F. Lehmann, 1939. Forms H. 4, Polit. Biol. HOFFMANN, Franz. Recoaro und seine Heilquellen; mit besonderer Rucksicht auf die daselbst neu errichtete Militar-Heilanstalt. x, 144p. 21cm. Wien, L. Sommer, 1854. HOFFMANN, Franz [Heinrich] 1893- *Ueber bosartige Geschwulste der peripheren Nerven (Auszug) 8p. 8? Bonn [n. pub.] 1922. HOFFMANN, Friedrich, 1660-1742. Leibbrand. W. Hoffmanns Theologie. In his Gottl. Stab d. Aeskulap, Salzb., 1939, 301-9. HOFFMANN, Friedrich, 1904- *In- fluenzabazillen-Peritonitis. 20p. 8? Bresl., Quader Druck, 1929. HOFFMANN, Friedrich Albert, 1820-63. Herting, J. Dr Friedrich Albert Hoffmann, Direktor der rheinischen Irrenanstalt Siegburg (1820-1863) Psychiat. neur. Wschr., 1939,41:206-10. HOFFMANN, Friedrich Wilhelm, 1910- * Ueber Cairbonsaurehypohalogenite [Wurzburg] 29p. 8? Berl. [to. pub.] 1935. HOFFMANN, Fritz, 1906- *Erfahrungen iiber das postoperative Ulcus pepticum jejuni und postoperative Magen-Darmbeschwerden. 31p. 8? Wurzb., Buchdr. Bavaria, 1931. HOFFMANN, Georg Franz, 1761-1826. Com- mentatio de vario lichenum usu; memoire qui a remporte le premier prix au jugement de l'Aca- d£mie. 68p. 8? Lyon, Piestre & Delamolliere, 1787. In Mem. Acad. Sc. Lyon, 1766, 3. Mim. See also Stellfeld, C. Hoffmann. Tribuna farm., Curitiba, 1942, 10: 4. HOFFMANN, Gerda, 1908- *Beitrage zur Lehre von der durch Zauber verursachten Krankheit und ihrer Behandlung in der Medizin des Mittelalters [Berlin] 37p. 8? Leiden, E. J. Brill, 1933. HOFFMANN, Gerda, 1914- *Ueber den Vitamin-C-Gehalt zubereiteter Gemuse und Ge- miisekonserven im Winter. 19p. 8? Jena [n. pub.] 1937. HOFFMANN, Gerhard, 1907- * Ueber die Operation des Mastdarmkrebses. 24p. 8? Heidelb,, Winter, 1932. HOFFMANN 7 HOFFMANN ---- Psychologie und arztliche Praxis, iv p 67p. 8? Berl , J. Springer, 1932. ----Ueber die Zwangsneurose; eine klinische Studie. 51 p. 8? Tub., F. F. Heine, 1934. ----Ueber Aerzte und Patienten. 54p. 8° Stuttg., F. Enke, 1935. ---- Das arztliche Weltbild (eine Genesoolo- gie) zwei Vortrage. vii, 52p. 22}£cm. Stuttg , F. Enke, 1937. HOFFMANN, Hubert, 1904- *Expen- mentell kritische Beitrage zur Frage der Ver- wendung abkochbarer Abdruckgipse in der Zahn- heilkunde. 31p. 8? Bonn, H. Trapp, 1935. HOFFMANN, Hugo von, 1846-1934. Hoffmann. M. Nekrolog. Klin. Mbl. Augenh., 1934, 93: 206. HOFFMANN, Irene, 1910- *Operations- mortalitat nach Magenresektionen aus der Chirurgischen Universitats-Klinik Leipzig von 1926 bis einschliesslich 1935 [Leipzig] 28p. 22y2cm. Zeulenroda, A. Oberreuter, 1936. HOFFMANN, Johanna, 1908- *Die Bedeutung der Wurzelspitzenresektion; ein ent- wicklungsgeschichtlicher Ueberblick [Heidel- berg] 20p. 8? [Mannheim, Haas] 1931. HOFFMANN [Johannes Heinrich Rudolf] Friedrich, 1899- *Geschwulstbildung im Wurmfortsatz [Leipzig] 23p. 8? Zeulenroda, A. Oberreuter, 1933. HOFFMANN, Josef. Beitrag zur Kenntnis der Alkali- und Bariumsilberchloride. p.25-8. 8? Wien, Holder-Pichler-Tempsky, 1933. Forms H. 302, Mitt. Inst. Radiumforsch., Wien. HOFFMANN, Josephine, 1905- *Des traitements physiotherapiques des cancers cu- tanea. 83p. 8? Par., M. Lac, 1930. HOFFMANN, Jules, 1901- *Les fausses sinusites maxillaires du nourrisson; sur un cas d'osteomyelite du maxillaire superieur chez un nourrisson. 40p. 8? Par., Jouve & cie, 1926. HOFFMANN, Julius, 1906- *Ein seltener Fall von Megalocornea. 20p. 8? Wiirzb., G. Schonlein, 1933. HOFFMANN, Karl, 1906- *Beobach- tungen an einem Fall von retropharyngealer Phlegmone im Kindesalter. 30p. 8? Freib. i. B. [n. pub.] 1930. HOFFMANN, Karl, 1912- *Ueber kiinst- lichen Pneumothorax; was lehrt uns das Schicksal gasbrustbehandelter Phthisiker. 28p. tab. 20^cm. Jena, 1937. [Mimeograph] HOFFMANN, Karl Ferdinand, 1909- *Zur Pharmakologie des Harnstoffs. 24p. 8? Marb.-Lahn, J. Hamel, 1933. HOFFMANN, Karlheinz, 1909- *Die Einwirkung der Hefenucleotide auf das weisse Blutbild des Kaninchens. 24p. 8? Lpz., Radelli & Hille, 1936. HOFFMANN, Karl Joachim, 1906- *Beitrag zur Pathogenese und Morphologie der Syringomyelic [Wurzburg] p.261-80. 8? Munch., J. F. Bergmann, 1931. Also Frankf. Zschr. Path., 1906, 42: HOFFMANN, Klaus [Friedrich Wilhelm] 1910- *Ueber neuzeitliche operative Be- handlung der Sehnenscheidenpanaritien. 23p. 20'/,cm. Konigsb., J. Raabe, 1936. HOFFMANN, Kurt, 1908- *Nac.>un- tersuchungen von Pylorospastikern (klinische und rontgenologische Nachuntersuchung von Kindern, die von 1925 bis 1937 an der Univer- sitats-Kinderklinik Breslau wegen Pylorospas- mus behandelt wurden) 40p. 8? Bresl., Genoss. Buchdr., 1938. HOFFMANN, Gerhard, 1913- *Neuro- fibromatose des kleinen Beckens; eine klinisch- anatomische Studie iiber zwei selten grosse Neurofibrome. 23p. 8? Berl., K. & R. Hoff- mann [1938] HOFFMANN, Gottfried Friedrich Rafael, 1832- [Biography] In Gallerie hervorrag. Ther. Pharmakogn. Gegenwart, Ceneve, 1897, 73-9, portr. HOFFMANN, Gunter, 1908- *Zahne, Kiefer und Leibesiibungen. 24p. 8? [Heidelb., n. pub., 1932] HOFFMANN, Hans, 1901- *Ueber Thera- pie und Prognose der Gynatresien (das Material der letzten 20 Jahre der Konigsberger Univer- sitats-Frauenklinik) 22p. 8? Konigsb., J. Raabe, 1926. HOFFMANN, Hans, 1904- *Zur Klinik carcinomatos entarteter Dermoide des Ovariums. 14p. 8? [Frankf. a. M., Henzel & Doland] 1930. HOFFMANN, Hans, 1909- *Ein weiterer Fall von gleichzeitiger intra- und extrauteriner Graviditat. 19p. 8? Wurzb., P. Scheiner, 1937. HOFFMANN, Hans, 1910- *Ueber Zu- falligkeiten und unerwiinschte Folgeerscheinun- gen bei einfachen zahnarztlichen Eingriffen. 50p. 8? Bonn, H. Trapp, 1934. HOFFMANN, Hans, 1913- *Die bak- teriologische Selbstreinigung der Dreisam von der Quelle bis zur Miindung. 40p. 2\y2cm. Freib. i. B., Cebr. Gunther, 1937. HOFFMANN, Hans [Giinter] 1908- *Klinische Hautuntersuchungen iiber die Wir- kung von technischen Losungsmitteln [Breslau] 39p. 8? Schweidnitz, P. Teusner, 1934. HOFFMANN, Hans Wilhelm, 1904- *Ueber die Phlorrhizinglykosurie und klinisch- experimentelle Untersuchungen mit Phlorrhizin bei Nierenkranken (Nephrosen) [Leipzig] 27p. 8? [Zeulenroda, A. Oberreuter, 1930] HOFFMANN, Heinrich, 1902- *Ueber iibergrosse Ovarialcystome. 31p. 8? Marb. [n. pub.] 1932. HOFFMANN, Heinz, 1910- *Ueber die chronisch entzundliche stenosierende Pericolitis ascendens [Berlin] 19p. 8? Wiirzb., R. Mayr, 1937. HOFFMANN, Heinz, 1911- *Zur Kennt- nis der Lambliose der Gallenwege und ihre Be- handlung [Berlin] 16p. 23cm. Bad Mergen- theim, C. Schonhuth, 1937. HOFFMANN, Heinz [Wilhelm August] 1902- *Ueber organische Siliciumverbindungen. 35p. 8? Jena [n. pub.] 1930. HOFFMANN, Hellmuth, 1902- *Pla- stischer Ersatz von Unterkieferdefekten. 16p. 8? Konigsb. [n. pub.] 1926. HOFFMANN, Helmut [Rudolf Walter] 1903- *Ein Fall von schragverengtem Becken [Heidelberg] 39p. 8? Heppenheim, G. Otto, 1927. HOFFMANN, Herbert. See Heilpern, Moses J., Porges, O., & Hoffmann, Herbert. Atlas der Gastrophotography. 29p. 8? Lpz., 1936. HOFFMANN, Herbert, 1905- *Ueber intrauterine Fruchtbeeinflussung. 26p. 8° Miinch., P. Denk, 1931. HOFFMANN, Herbert, 1910- *Die Be- handlung der pernieiObcn Anaemie [Greifswald] 31p. 8? Lengerich, Lengerich. Handelsdr., 1936. HOFFMANN, Herman Fritz, 1891- Das Problem des Charakteraufbaus; seine Gestaltung durch die erbbiologische Personlichkeitsanalyse vii, 193p. 8? Berl., J. Springer, 1926. HOFFMANN 743 HOFFMANN HOFFMANN, Kurt [Georg Werner] 1909- *Beziehungen zwischen manisch-depressivem Ir- resein und Paralyse. 24p. 8? Bresl., K. Klossok, 1938. HOFFMANN, Leon, 1897- *Les mutila- tions ne sont pas hei£ditaires. 47p. 8? Par., M. Vigne, 1927. HOFFMANN, Liselotte, 1908- *Spat- schicksale von Hydramnionkindern. 22p. 8? Bresl., K. Vater, 1934. HOFFMANN, Lotte, 1907- komplika- tionen bei Kieferhohlenspiilungen. 35p. 8? Konigsb., J. Raabe, 1934. HOFFMANN, Margot [geb. Ring] 1899- *Beitrag zum akuten Beginn der Lungentuberku- lose des Erwachsenen. 26p. 8? Bresl. [n. pub.] 1930. HOFFMANN, Maria, 1905- *Ueber die Geburt jugendlicher Erstgebarender von 13-18 Jahren an der Bonner Universitats-Frauenklinik in den Jahren 1912-1934. 39p. 8? Bonn, G. Kersting, 1935. HOFFMANN, Max, 1912- *Die Vital- amputation mit Calxyl bei entziindeten Pulpen. 51p. 13 pl. 22#cm. Zur. [n. pub.] 1939. Also Schweiz. Mschr. Zahnh., 1939, 49: HOFFMANN, Melitta [Margarete Otti Inge- borg,] 1909- *Kopf- und Halswirbelverlet- zungen in landwirtschaftlichen Betrieben und ihre Auswirkungen. 19p. 8? Greifsw., H. Adler, 1934. HOFFMANN [Mile] Les methodes de l'Ecole maternelle Francaise. 62p. 8? Par., F. Nathan, 1927. HOFFMANN, Oswald Willy, 1905- *Ueber atypische Cystennieren und Cystenleber [Munchen] 23p. 2 1. 8? Lodz [n. pub.] 1931. HOFFMANN, Ottilie, 1835-1925. Blucher, G. von. Ottilie Hoffmann zum Gedachtnis. Alkoholfrage, 1926, 22: 25-9. HOFFMANN, Otto, 1895- ♦Verglei- chende Untersuchungen iiber den Indolnachweis. 43p. tab. 8? Giessen, R. Glagow, 1931. HOFFMANN, Paul, 1900- *Zur funk- tionellen Diagnostik der Anaemie bei Nieren- kranken. 56p. 8? Berl., E. Ebering, 1933. HOFFMANN, Paul Theodor, 1891- Der mittelalterliche Mensch. 2. Aufl. 313p. 8? Lpz., J. C. Hinrich, 1937. HOFFMANN, Rebecca [n6e Retzky] *Con- tribution a l'etude des epitheliomes du thymus. 23p. 8? Lausanne, Impr. Borgeaud, 1924. HOFFMANN, Richard, 1863- [Biography] Zschr. Laryng., 1933, 24: 367. HOFFMANN, Richard, 1905- *Ueber Herrmannsdorfer-Diat in der Therapie der Lungentuberkulose [Leipzig] 26p. 8? Zeu- lenroda, A. Oberreuter, 1932. HOFFMANN, Roger. Contribution a l'etude de la cure radicale de la hernie inguinale par le procede de Girard modifie. 18p. 8? Geneve, Impr. Jent, 1926. HOFFMANN, Rudolf, 1900- *Ueber die Klassifizierung verstiimmelter Gebisse fiir die Herstellung partieller Prothesen. 28p. 8? Bresl., A. Schreiber, 1933. HOFFMANN, Ruth, 1913- *Untersu- chungen iiber die zeitliche Abhangigkeit des Zahnwechsels vom Gesundheitszustand des Milchzahngebisses [Breslau] 36p. 21cm. Len- gerich, Lengerich. Handelsdr., 1937. HOFFMANN, Theodor, 1904- *Ueber Thorakoplastik [Kiel] 25p. 8? Wurzb., K. Triltsch, 1936. HOFFMANN, Ursula, 1910- *Leiomy- °RmMdaevrr, IS*' 14P" ' PL 8? WUrzb" HOFFMANN, Ursula, 1913- *Vitamine und Haut [Berlin] 53p. 23cm. Charlottenb., K. & R. Hoffmann, 1938. HOFFMANN, Victor, 1890- Verlauf der wichtigsten Knochen- und Gelenkerkran- kungen im Rontgenbilde; eine anschauliche Prog- nostik, mit deutschem und englischem Text 264p. 8? Berl., J. Springer, 1931. HOFFMANN, Waldemar [Alexander Eduard] 1910- *Ueber Darmverschluss durch den Processus vermiformis [Kiel] 29p. 8? Qua- kenbruck, R. Kleinert, 1933. HOFFMANN, Waldtraut, 1909- *Ueber Beziehungen der Berufsart zu dem Geschlecht der Nachkommenschaft [Frankfurt] 19p. 8? Gelnhausen, F. W. Kalbfleisch, 1935. HOFFMANN, Walter, 1908- *Ueber die Beteiligung der Schleimhaut an der Haut- tuberkulose. 20p. 8? [Berl., n. pub.] 1931. HOFFMANN, Walter, 1909- *Unter- schied in der Herzwirkung der Lokalanaesthetika bei innerer und ausserer Einwirkung. 59p. 8? Gott., M. Sass, 1934. HOFFMANN, Walter, 1909- *Epiphy- senlosung bei Jugendlichen. 27p. 20}|cm. Erlangen, K. Dores, 1938. HOFFMANN, Walter, 1910- *Ueber Stauungspapille nach Schadeltrauma. 27p. 8? Jena, G. Neuenhahn, 1936. HOFFMANN, Werner, 1903- *Zur Frage der Serumtherapie bei Scharlach [Berlin] 42p. 8? Rastenburg [Rastenburg Ztg, 1934] HOFFMANN, Werner, 1905- *Die Be- schaffenheit der Vorzugsmilch einer mittel- deutschen Groszstadt vom Standpunkt der Milchhygiene. 44p. 8? Lucka, R. Berger, 1930. HOFFMANN, Werner, 1909- *Ueber 60 Falle von Agranulocytose am Berliner Vir- chow-Krankenhaus, 1922-35 [Berlin] 20p. 21cm. Gutersloh, Thiele, 1936. HOFFMANN, Wilhelm. See Hebestreit, H., Hoffmann, W., & Teitge, H. Schutz und Erhaltung der Arbeitskraft. 338p. 21J-icm. Berl.. 1939. HOFFMANN, Wilhelm, 1872- See Waldmann, Anton, & Hoffmann, Wilhelm. Lehrbuch der Militarhygiene. 759p. 8? Berl., 1936. HOFFMANN, Wilhelm, 1900- *Ueber Remissionen bei progressiver Paralyse nach Malariabehandlung [Leipzig] 15p. 2 1. 8? Hemau, J. Scheck, 1927. HOFFMANN, Wilhelm H., 1875- Ueber Wesen und Ursache der afrikanischen Schlaf- krankheit. 115p. 8? Wiesbaden, J. F. Berg- mann, 1912. Forms Sonderbd v.16. Erg. allg. Path. ---- Tropenarzt und Gelbfieber. 14p. 8? Wurzb. [n. pub.] 1934. ---- Einige Beobachtungen bei parasito- logischen Arbeiten an Reptilien. p.31-36. [l]p. pl. 25j4cm. Leningr., 1935. At head of tp. Inst. Finlay, Habana; Sonder-Abdruck aus der Festschrift fur E. N. Pawlowsky [&c] ---- La endemicidade da febre amarela, no continente africano. p.69-84. 8? Lisb. [n. pub.] 1935. ---- La muda interna en los reptiles I5]p. illust. 24cm. Habana, Inst. Finlay, 1936. Repr. from Rev. parasit., No. 2. ---- La provision que poseen los hemipteros para su cria. p.577-83. 8? Habana, 1936. Repr. from Rev. parasit., 1936, 2: ---- La vida molecular. p. 135-40. 8? Habana, 1936. Repr. from Rev. parasit., 1936, 2: No. 2. HOFFMANN 744 HOFFSCHILD ---- Zur bakteriologischen Diagnose der Lepra, p.210-15. 27Hcm. Hamb., 1937. Repr. from Festschr. Nocht, 1937. ---- Das Finlay-Institut und die Gelbfieber- miicke. p.1589-1603. portr. 28cm. Weimar, G. Uschmann, 1939. Repr. from Verh. 7. Internat. Kongr. Entom., 1938, v.3. ---- El Instituto Finlay y la nueva epi- demiologfa de la fiebre amarilla. 92p. 5 pl. map. 26^cm. Habana, Comp. ed. libros y folletos O'Reilly, 1939. No. 7, Monogr. Inst. Finlay. HOFFMANN, Wilhelm Ludwig, 1913- *Die pharmakologischen Wirkungen des Ben- zylamins und seiner Homologen [Frankfurt] 24p. 21cm. Asch affen burg, Riickziegel, 1937. HOFFMANN, Wilhelm [Rudolf Paul] 1903- *Die Knochen- und Hauttransplantationen bei einer schweren Schussverletzung des Ober- kiefers (ein Beitrag zur Therapie der Schuss- verletzungen) 29p. 8? Kiel [n. pub.] 1931. HOFFMANN, Wolfgang, 1893- See Birch-Hirschfeld, Arthur, & Hoffmann, Wolfgang. Die Lichtbehandlung in der Augenheilkunde. 112p. 8? Berl., 1928. HOFFMANN, Wolfgang, 1910- *Ange- borene Nabelschnurhernie [Freiburg] 15p. 8? Berl., K. Hustedt, 1934. HOFFMANN-DONNER, Heinrich, 1809-94. Struwwelpetei-Hoffmann erzahlt aus seinem Leben. 3 p. 1. 231p. 4 pl. 2 portr. fac. 4? Frankf. a. M., Englert & Schlosser, 1926. HOFFMANN-La ROCHE, F., & Co. Grund- lagen und Ergebnisse der Digitalistherapie; zum 25jahrigen Jubilaum des Digalen Roche, 1904- 29. 95p. 8? Basel, 1929. HOFFMANNS, Willy, 1897- *Hypo- plasien des Gebisses und Kieferdeformitaten; eine Studie an Rasseschadeln mit besonderer Beriick- sichtigung der Naturvblker. 15p. 8? [Bonn, n. pub.] 1921. HOFFMANNS BACILLUS. See Corynebacterium, pseudodiphtheriae. HOFFMANS, Friedrich, 1660- Diepgen, P. [Biography] Deut. med. Wschr., 1935, 61: 389. HOFFMEIER, Otto, 1910- *Haufigkeit der Leberzirrhose; die Rolle der Leberzirrhose im Sektionsmaterial des Wurzburger Pathologischen Instituts, 1891-1934. lip. 8? Wurzb., R. Mayr, 1935. HOFFMEISTER, Alfred, 1906- *Bildung von Acetaldehyd bei der pankreatischen Ver- dauung und bei der Bestrahlung von Eiweiss- korpern [Breslau] p. 183-92. 8? Berl., W. de Gruyter & co., 1932. Also Zschr. physiol. Chem., 1932, 205: HOFFMEISTER, Erika, 1913- *Ueber Sinus- und Jugularisthrombosen ohne wirkliche beziehungsweise nur scheinbare Temperaturer- hohung [Frankfurt] 27p. 8? Lengerich, Lengerich. Handelsdr., 1937. HOFFMEISTER, Hermann, 1911- *Der orthodontische Abdruck. 88p. tab. 8? Bonn H. Trapp, 1934. HOFFMEISTER, Wolfgang, 1910- *Grundlagen der Ulcusbehandlung. 19p. 8° Heidelb., E. Burkhardt, 1937. HOFFNER, Margarete, 1902- Ver- gleichende Blutmengenbestimmungen nach der CO- und Farbstoffsmethode. 16p. 8? Freib i B., Mors & Singler, 1933. HOFFSCHILD, Harry, 1908- *Ueber Osteodystrophia fibrosa localisata und die Frage ihrer Spontanheilung [Rostock] 16p. 8° Liibeck, IT. G. Rahtgens, 1935. HOFFSTAEDT, Ernst. Die Organneurose im Lichte neuerer Anschauungen. 26p. S? Berl H. Kornfeld, 1928. Forms H. 388, v.35, Berl. Klin. HOFFVENIUS, Petrus. 1630-82. [Biography] In Portr. Sven. lak. apot. (Sjobeig, N.) Stockh., 1910, 53, portr.—Nylander. E. S. Petrus Hnfifwenius; den svenska lakekonstens fader; till 250-arsminnet av hans dod den 23 maj 1682. Upsala lak. foren. forh., 1932 33, n. F., .18: art. Ill, 95, portr. HOFFZIMMER, Rudolf, 1908- * Ueber die bei Unterkieferfrakturen entstelienden Dis- lokationen [Munster] 25p. 22cm. Diisseld., G. H. Nolte, 1935. HOFGRAEFF. For portrait see Billroth's Assistenten von 1867-89 [portrait assembly] HOFHEINZ, Gerhart. 1905- *Zur Kennt- nis der Polycythaemia rubra, p. 103-13. 8? [Wurzb., n. pub.] 1928. Also Deut. Arch. klin. Med., 1929, 163: HOFIUS, Eduard, 1898- *Ueber aus- gedehnte Diinndarmresectionen [Bonn] 30p. 8? Holderb. b. Moers, P. Sonning & co., 1922. HOFMANN, Albin, 1912- *Beitrag zur Tuberkulose des Eierstockes [Erlangen] 23p. 22cm. Coburg [n. pub.] 1937. HOFMANN, Alfons [Ottmar] 1906- *Ex- tracranielle Ausbreitung der Hirntumoren [Frei- burg] 23p. 8? Bonn, P. Kubens, 1932. HOFMANN, Alfred [Conrad Paul] 1911- *Ueber die Problematik der partiellen Prothese, unter besonderer Berucksichtigung des Bruckener- satzes. 45p. 8? Lpz., A. Edelmann, 1935. HOFMANN, August Wilhelm, 1818-92. Portrait. In Hist. Chem. (Moore, F. J.) 3. ed., N. Y., 1939, p. 226. HOFMANN, Bernhard [Raimund] 1903- *Ein Fall von schwerer Wismut-Vergiftung [Berlin] 16p. 8? Lippstadt, Thiele, 1933. HOFMANN, Bferta] 1896- *Erfahrungen mit dem Scharlach-Heilserum der Behringwerke beim Erwachsenen. 24p. 8? Miinch., C. Wolf & Sohn, 1929. HOFMANN, Brunhilde, 1904- *Ueber postoperative Acetonurie [Erlangen] lip. 8? Berl., L. Schumacher, 1930. Also Beitr. klin. Chir., 1930, 149: HOFMANN, Eduard von, 1837-97. Atlas of legal medicine; authorized translation from the German, edited by Frederick Peterson, assisted by Aloysius O. J. Kelly, [v. p.] 56 pl. 8? Phila., W. B. Saunders, 1898. ---- Lehrbuch der gerichtlichen Medizin, mit gleichmassiger Berucksichtigung der deutschen und osterreichischen Gesetzgebung. 11. Aufl. vollstanding umgearb. von Albin Haberda & Julius Wagner-Jauregg. xi, 1234p. 8? Berl., Urban & Schwarzenberg, 1927. HOFMANN, Elisabeth, 1896- *Haema- tologische und bakteriologische Untersuchungen beim Erythema exsudativum multiforme [Miin- chen] 21p. 8? Wurzb., R. Mayr. 1934. HOFMANN, Elisabeth, 1913- *Korper- liches Befinden und Einstellung von Frauen, die nach dem Erbgesundheitsgesetz sterilisiert wur- den [Heidelberg] 24p. 8? Wurzb., R. Myar, 1937. HOFMANN, Emil. Preisbewegung und Kosten der Lebenshaltung in Mannheim im Jahre (1932- 36) [v. p.] 8? Mannheim, 1933-37. HOFMANN, Erich. See Brednow, W., & Hofmann, E. Rdntgenatlas der Lungenerkrankungen [&c] ]66p. 8? Berl., 1931. Also 3, Aufl. 255p. 25\Acm. Berl., 1938. HOFMANN 745 HOFMANN HOFMANN, Ermelinde. *Pylorushypertro- phie bei schweren Anamien. 22p. 8? Miinch. [n. pub.] 1927. HOFMANN, Erna, 1892- *Myokarditis nach Diphtherie [Jena] 32p. 8? Borna-Lpz., R. Noske, 1935. HOFMANN, Ernst, 1898- *Der heutige Stand der Beurteilung der beruflichen Meniskus- Verletzungen [Heidelberg] 30p. 21cm. Saar- briicken, Gebr. Hofer, 1936. HOFMANN, Eugen, 1911- *Ueber die Bedeutung von Salvarsaninjektionen fiir die Behandlung von Osteomyelitiden im Bereiche der Kiefer. 63p. 8? Wiirzb. [n. pub.] 1936. HOFMANN, Felix. *Orientierende Beitrage zum heutigen Stand der Therapie des schweren elektrischen Unfalles (Behandlung des Schein- todes) [Zurich] 62p. 8? Uznach, K. Ober- holzers Erben, 1927. HOFMANN, Franz Bruns, 1869-1926. Bielschowsky, A. Nekrolog. Klin. Mbl. Augenh., 1926, 77: 200. Also Zschr. Pscyhol. Physiol. Sinnesorg., 2. Abt., 1926, 58: 1-4.—Briicke, E. T. Nekrolog. Klin. Wschr., 1926, 5: 1398.—BrUckner, A. Nekrolog. Zbl. ges. Ophth., 1926, 16: 769-71.—Dittler. Nekrolog. Deut. med. Wschr. 1926, 52:, 1264.—Du Bois-Reymond, R. Nekrolog. Med. Klin., BerL, 1926, 22: 1060.—Durig. Nekrolog. Wien. klin. Wschr., 1926, 39: 797.—Frey, M. von. Nekrolog. Zschr. Biol., 1926, 85: H. 1, front.—Hering, H. E. Nekrolog. Miinch. med. Wschr., 1926, 73: 1753—Mangold, E. Das Lebenswerk von F. B. Hofmann. Arch. ges. Physiol., 1927, 216: 281-99.—Tschermak, A. Nekrolog. Erg. Physiol., 1928, 26: 776-80. HOFMANN, Frieda, 1909- *Die direkte Pulpa-LTeberkappung nach der Dentinsplitter- methode; klinische und histologische Unter- suchungen. 27p. 8 pl. 22>^cm. Zur., 1937. HOFMANN, Friedrich, 1906- *Ueber die Wirkung von Radiothorium auf den Stoff- wechsel. 29p. 8? Wiirzb., K. Roll, 1930. HOFMANN, Friedrich, 1907- *Ueber spontanen idiopathischen todlichen Haemato- Pneumo-Thorax und Haemato-Thorax. 16p. 21cm. Erlangen, K. Dores, 1937. HOFMANN, Fritz. *Ueber Duodenal-Diverti- kel (Auszug) [Leipzig] 7p. 8? Oschatz, C. Morgner, 1925. HOFMANN, Fritz, 1907- *Neuere Un- tersuchungen iiber die sogenannten Schmelzla- mellen. 9p. 8? Wurzb. [n. pub.] 1930. HOFMANN, Genevieve [nee Saguez] 1911- *L'osteomyelite du nourrisson. 105p. 8? Par., E. Le Francois, 1937. HOFMANN, Hans, 1900- *Fehlgriffe in der Zahnheilkunde [Heidelberg] 23p. 8? Walldorf, F. Lamade, 1929. HOFMANN, Helene, 1909- *Ueber die Vererbung der Augenfarbe und ihre Korrelation zur Haarfarbe [Giessen] 21p. 22>^cm. Wiirzb., K. Triltsch, 1935. HOFMANN, Helmuth, 1907- *Die Ur- sachen des plotzlichen Todes im Wasser. 23p. 21cm. Heidelb., H. Fahrer, 1936. HOFMANN, Herbert, 1909- *Ueber den Einfluss einiger neuerer Konservierungsmittel auf Hefegarung, Pepsin- und Trypsin-Verdauung. 24p. 8° Erlangen, K. Dores, 1933. See also Uslenghi, J. P., Hofmann, H., & Heilpern, J. La fotograffa del est6mago. 215p. 23cm. B. Air., 1939. HOFMANN, Herbert, 1909- *Ueber die Erblichkeit von Haarform und Haarfarbe [Gies- sen] 30p. 8? Wurzb., K. Triltsch, 1935. HOFMANN, Hildegard, 1909- ♦Menis- cus-Verletzungen und ihre Behandlung [Frei- burg] 23p. 21cm. Halle, E. Karras, 1936. HOFMANN, Use, 1911- * Aetiologie und Therapie von Hautfisteln dentalen Ursprungs. 22p. 8? Bonn, P. Kubens, 1934. HOFMANN, Joachim, 1913- *Die Charak- tensierung des B. Coli, insbesondere der Darmcoh, und die hygienische Bewertung seines Vorkommens im Trinkwasser (auf Grund der bishengen Literaturangaben) [Frankfurt] 19p 21cm. Gelnhausen, F. W. Kalbfleisch, 1937. HOFMANN, Johan Jakob, & RAYGER, Karoly (resp.) *Exercitatio anatomico-physio- logica de fluidorum catholicorum foetus motu. 20p. 19cm. Altdorf, H. Meyer [1695] In P. v. Altdorf theses pt 1, No. 13. HOFMANN, Johan Moriz, 1653-1727, & BEUTTEL, Johan Georg (resp.) *Disputatio medica publica de medicamentis martialibus. 56p. 19cm. Altdorf, H. Meyer [1685] In P. v. Altdorf theses pt 1, No. 12. HOFMANN, Johan Moriz, & FRANK, Georg Friedrich (resp.) *Excercitatio medica de peri- cardio, atque experimentis & observationibus novissimis circa id habitis. 30p. 19cm. Altdorf, H. Meyer [1690] In P. v. Altdorf theses pt 1, No. 9. HOFMANN, Johan Moriz, & MEIBOM, Daniel Heinrich (resp.) *Exercitatio physiolo- gico-medica de suturis cranii humani earumque usu. 26p. 19cm. Altdorf, H. Meyer [1691] In P. v. Altdorf theses pt 1, No. 8. HOFMANN, Josef, 1911- *Ueber eine Kombination von lymphatischer Leukamie und Polycythemia rubra [Erlangen] 23p. 8? Wiirzb., R. Mayr, 1937. HOFMANN, Josef A., 1905- *Ueber die Strahlenbehandlung des Zungenkarzinoms [Munchen] 31p. 8° Wiirzb., R. Mayr, 1934. HOFMANN, Karl, 1885- *Die Rinder- zucht, insbesondere die Zucht des Pinzgauer Rindes, im Chiemgau [Miinchen] 223p. 13 pl. tab. 8? Traustein, E. Leopoldseder, 1928. HOFMANN, Karl, 1899- *Ueber die Temperatursteigerungen im Wochenbett an Hand des Materials der Universitats-Frauenklinik in Frankfurt a. Main wahrend der Jahre 1913-1923 (eine statistische Arbeit) [Frankfurt] 16p. tab. ch. 8? Limburg-Lahn, G. Jaeger, 1925. HOFMANN, Karl Andreas, 1870- Ent- wicklung des chemischen Unterrichtes von Stock- hardts' Schule der Chemie (1855) bis zur Anor- ganischen Chemie von K. A. Hofmann und Ulrich Hofmann (1938) 12p. 29/2cm. Berl., W. de Gruyter & co., 1940. Forms No. 8, Abh. Preuss. Akad. Wiss., math, naturwiss. Kl. HOFMANN, Karl Heinrich R[einhold] 1909- *Untersuchung der sedativen Wirkung einiger Antipyretica durch antagonistische Be- einflussung der Cardiazolkrampfreaktion [Leip- zig] 20p. 23}4cm. Zeulenroda, A. Oberreuter, 1936. HOFMANN, Konrad [Karl Wilhelm] 1909- *Vergleichende Untersuchungen des Gebisses bei Volksernahrung mit Brotsorten verschiedener Konsistenz. 36p. 2112cm. Marb., A. Zetl, 1936. HOFMANN, Kurt, 1904- *Chemische Studien und Untersuchungen an Phosphat- und Silikatzementen, unter besonderer Berucksichti- gung des Pulpentodes unter Silikatfiillungen. 32p. 8? Wiirzb., Gebr. Memminger, 1935. HOFMANN, Kurt, 1910- *Experimen- telle physikalische Untersuchungen uber Ver- arbeitungsweise^ Druck-, Stoss- und Bruch- festigkeit eines in der konservierenden Zahn- heilkunde neu einzufiihrenden Zementes X. 23}), .8? . .Wiirzb. [n. pub.]J1935. HOFMANN 746 HOFMEISTER HOFMANN, Leo, 1909- *Ueber eine Beobachtung von Echinokokkuserkrankung des Beckens [Munchen] 26p. pl. 8° Kiel, H. Ltidtke, 1937. HOFMANN. Luise [Johanna] 1902- *De- kapitation oder Spondylotomie bei verschleppter Querlage? 16p. 2 1. 8? Marb., J. Hamel, 1927. HOFMANN, Max, 1908- * Vererbung von Spalthand und Spaltfuss; Beobachtungen an 2 Familien [Miinchen] 31p. 8? Spever, Pilger, 1936. HOFMANN, Nikolaus, 1906- *Ueber Haematome und ihre Organisation [Giessen] 19p. 2 pl. 8? Birkenfeld, H. Enke, 1931. HOFMANN, Paul, 1902- *Die dentalen Kieferhohlenempyeme und das Verhalten der Zahnpulpen nach der Radikaloperation der Kieferhohle (Denker) [Freiburg] 16p. 8? Lahr, H. Maier, 1926. HOFMANN, Philipp, 1907- *Ruckfalle im positiven Gonokokkenbefund wahrend der Behandlung der weiblichen Gonorrhoe ohne vorausgegangene Provokation [Miinchen] 19p. 8? Ingolstadt, A. Ganghofer, 1930. HOFMANN, Raymund, 1908- *Cysten im Oberkiefer. 82p. 8? Bonn, P. Kubens, 1932. HOFMANN, Rudolf. *Zur Verhiitung der Keimverschleppung in den Uterus durch die Hand des Geburtshelfers (bei Lageverbesserun- gen, YYendungen, Austastungen und Xach- gebuitslosungen) [Munchen] 23p. 8? Kall- miinz, M. Lassleben, 1936. HOFMANN, Rudolf, 1905- *Ueber die traumatische Entstehung von Nierensteinen. 31p. 8? Wurzb., K. Roll, 1931. HOFMANN, Siegfried, 1912- *Ueber freie Korper in der Vorderkammer sonst vollig regelrechter Augen [Berlin] 15p. 21cm. Co- burg, A. Rossteutscher, 1938. HOFMANN, Werner, 1910- *Ueber die Bedeutung der Milch als Infektionsquelle bei mehreren Banginfektionen am Niederrhein [Gies- sen] 24p. 22cm. Diisseld., G. H. Nolte, 1937. HOFMANN, Werner, 1911- *Zur Kennt- nis der Bakterien- und Pilzflora des Camem- bertkases in verschiedenem Reifungszustand. 52p. 8? Kiel [n. pub.] 1935. HOFMANN, Wilhelm, 1900- *Das Blut- bild bei experimentell erzeugter Rattenrachitis und seine Beeinflussung durch Hohensonne und bestrahltes Oel. 12p. 8? Miinch. [n. pub.] 1926. HOFMANN, Wilhelm, 1912- *Neue- rungen auf dem Gebiet der zahnarztlichen Kera- mik [Tiibingen] 21p. 8? Urach, F. Buhler, 1935. HOFMANN, Willi. Leibesiibungen, ein Heil- mittel in der Medizin der Antike. 3 p. 1. 45p. 21 ^cm. Diisseld., G. H. Nolte, 1938. Forms H. 3, Diisseld. Arb. Gesch. Med. (Haberling) HOFMEIER, Kurt. *Die Bedeutung der Erbanlagen fur die Kinderheilkunde [Habilita- tionsschrift] 208p. 29>2cm. [Berl., n. pub., 1938] Also Arch. Kinderh., 1938, Beih. 14: HOFMEIER, Max, 1854-1927. Franque, O. von. Nekrolog". Verh. Phys. med. Ges Wurzburg, 1927, n. F., 52: 153-69.—Polano. Nekrolog. Munch, med. Wschr., 1927, 74: 859.— Schmitt, W. Nekrolog. "\ erh. Phys. med. Ges. Wurzburg, 1927, n. F., 52: 169-71.— Stoeckel. Nekrolog. Zschr. Geburtsh. Gyn., 1927, 91: p. i-viii.—Winter, G. Nekrolog. Arch. Gyn., Berl., 1927, 130: p. i-viii, portr. HOFMEISTER, Bruno, 1900- *Ueber Zahnzemente (Auszug) 9p. 8? Lpz. [n. pub.] HOFMEISTER, Franz von. 1867-1926. Burk, W. Nekrolog. Med. Korbl. Wurttemberg, 1920 96: 402. HOFMEISTER, Franz, 1904- *Zur Kasu- istik der chronischen indurierenden Thyreoiditia feisenharte Struma Riedel) 18p. 8? Tiib E. Gobel, 1927. HOFMEISTER, Julie [Esswein] 1909- *Ueber Augen verletzungen bei Kindern; nach dem Material der Univ.-Augenklinik Tubingen 1922-31. 20p. 8? Tiib., A. Becht, 1935. HOFMEISTER, Richard, 1908- *Ueber die Anatomie der Tonsilla palatina des Menschen anhand eines Wachsplattenmodelles der epi- thelialen Bestandteile der Tonsilla palatina [Jena] 15p. 8? Zeulenroda, B. Sporn, 1936. HOFMEISTER, Theodor, 1890- *Ex- perimentelle Untersuchungen zur Frage der hormonalen Unterbrechung der Schwangerschaft. 56p. 8? Marb. [n. pub.] 1931. HOFMEISTER, Wilhelm, 1822-77. Goebel, K. Wilhelm Hofmeister; the work and life of a nineteenth century botanist, with a biographical supplement by Frau Ganzenmiiller, born Hofmeister; transl. by H. M. Bower. 202p. 8? Lond., 1926. HOFNER, Carl Max, 1911- *Eine absolute Messmethode von Radiumemanation [Freiburg] 16p. 8? Wiirzb., R. Mayr, 1935. HOFRATH, Herbert. Die Rontgenographie im Dienste der Gebiss- und Kieferorthopadie. p. 1065-1145. 25^cm. Miinch., J. F. Bergmann, 1939. In Handb. Zahnheilk. (C. Bruhn) 1.-2. Aufl., Bd 4. HOFSTAETTER, Robert, 1883- Die rauchende Frau; eine klinische psychologischc und soziale Studie. iv, 266p. 8? Wien, Holder- Pichler-Tempsky A. G., 1924. ---- Ueber eingebildete Schwangerschaften. 2 p. 1. 47p. 8? Berl., Urban & Schwarzenberg, 1924. f HOFSTEIN, Jules, 1904- *Influence du regime sans sei sur la secretion gastrique; applica- tions thei-apeutiques. 60p. 8? Strasb., C. & J. Goeller, 1932. HOFSTETTER, Ernst, 1906- *Unter- suchungen iiber die Wirkung des Pilocarpins auf die Wasserausscheidung der normalen Haut. 17p. 8? Miinch. [n. pub.] 1930. HOFWEBER [Wilhelm Eduard] H[erbert] 1904- *Ueber die Funktion des von Wieders- heim als dorsaler Larynx gedeuteten Gebildes bei Lepidosiren paradoxa [Munchen] p.95-118. 8? Jena, G. Fischer, 1926. Also Zool. Jahrb., 1926-27, Abt. Anat., 48: HOG. See Swine. HOGAN, F. Edmund. The Irish people; their height, form, and strength. 176p. 16? Dubl., Scaly, Bryers & Walker, 1899. HOGAN, J. L. (Mrs.) See Hogan, Louise E. (Shimer) HOGAN, Louise E. (Shimer) How to feed children; a manual for mothers, nurses and physicians, a cook book for the nursery and the school child. 11. ed. xiv, 249p. 5 pl. 8? N. Y., Reader pub., 1926. HOGARTH, Alfred Moore, 1876- British mosquitoes and how to eliminate them. 3 p. 1. 127p. front. 7 pl. 12? Lond., Hutchinson & co. [1928] ---- The rat: a world menace; with a preface by Thomas Horder. vi, 112p. 2 pl. 8? Lond.. J. Bale, sons & Danielsson, 1929. HOGARTH 747 HOHAGE HOGARTH, Basil. Self mastery through psycho-analysis, x, 160p. 8? Lond., Rider & co. [1935] HOGARTH, Francois, 1901- *Les voies hypodermique et nasale dans le traitement du diabete insipide par l'extrait hypophysaire posterieur. 47p. 8? Par., M. Lac, 1928. HOGARTH, William, 1697-1764. Anatomical (An) demonstration in Barber's Hall, 1750. Messenger, 1942, 39:2. HOGBEN, Lancelot Thomas, 1895- Com- parative physiology, xiv, 219p. pl. 8? N. Y., Macmillan co., 1926. --- Comparative physiology of internal secretion. 4 p. 1. 148p. 8? Cambr., Eng., Univ. Press, 1927. •--- Principles of animal biology, xxiv, 332. 4 pl. 8? Lond., Christophers [1930] Also [2. ed.] 12p. 2 1. [15J-415P. illust. pl. tab. diagr. 21cm. N. Y., W. W. Norton & co. [1940] ---- The nature of living matter, ix, 316p. 8? Lond., K. Paul, Trench, Trubner & co., 1930. ---- Genetic principles in medicine and social science. 230p. 8? Lond., Williams & Norgate, 1931. --- Nature and nurture. 143p. diagrs. 8? Lond., G. Allen & Unwin, 1933. —— Political arithmetic; a symposium of population studies. 3 p. 1. 531, [l]p. incl. illust. maps tab. diagr. 24cm. N. Y., Macmillan co., 1938. ---- Science for the citizen; a self-educator based on the social background of scientific discovery; illust. by J. F. Horrabin. 1120p. illust. diagr. 24cm. Lond., G. Allen & Unwin [1938] HOG CHOLERA. See Swine fever. HOGE, E. Etude des anomalies de la com- posante verticale du champ magnetique terrestre dans la region des Hautes Fagnes. 40p. tab. map. 4? Brux., Pal. des Academies, 1935. Forms Fase. 2. Vol. 11,2. ser. Mem. Acad. Belgique. HOGE, Johann Gerhard. *Ureumretentie door gebrek aan keukenzout [Groningen] 131p. 8? Amst., H. J. Paris, 1932. HOGEBOOM, Floyde Eddy. Practical pedo- dontia; or, Juvenile operative dentistry and pub- lic health dentistry; an introductory text for students and practitioners of dentistry. 2. ed. 3 p. 1. 108p. 25cm. S. Louis, C. V. Mosby co., 1927. Also 3. ed. 328p. illust. 1933. Also 4. ed. 2 p. 1. 371p. incl. illust. diagr. 1938. HOG FLUE. See Swine influenza. HOGG, Frederick Stapleton Dickey, -1937. Obituary. Lancet, Lond., 1937, 1: 955. HOGGAN, Frances Elizabeth, 1843-1927. Obituary. Lancet, Lond., 1927, 1: 412. HOGGAN, Isme Aldyth, 1899-1936, Johnson, J. Obituary. Phytopathology, 1937, 27: 1029-32, portr. HOGIVAL. See under Estrogen. HOGREFE, Hansjbrg, 1910- lnter- suchungen iiber die Entstehung des Foetor ex ore. 24p. 8? Miinch., Bayer. Druck [1933] HOGUE, William P., 1820-97. Treatment of diphtheria and croup. 24p. 16? Charleston, J. W. Jarrett, 1892. HOHAGE, Erich, 1911- *Ein todlicher Unfall durch Vergiftung nach Benutzung von Tetrachlorkohlenstoff enthaltenden Feuerlosch- apparaten. 33p. 21cm. Marb., A. Zetl, 1937. HOHAGEN, Kurt, 1903- *Experimen- telle Untersuchungen iiber die Beziehungen zwischen Niere und Blutdruck. 43p. 8? Bonn, H. Trapp, 1930. HOHBACH, Hans, 1901- *Ueber einen Fall von primarer Darmtuberkulose. 42p. 8° Erlangen, Hofer & Limmert, 1927. HOHBERG, Use, 1909- *Versuche mit einem neuen Desinfektionsmittel Bazillotox [Breslau] 27p. 8? Ohlau, H. Eschenhagen, HOHE, Hermann, 1899- *Ueber zwei Falle von Mykosis fungoides. 48p. 2 pl. 22cm. Erlangen, K. Dores, 1935. HOHEISEL, Walter, 1911- *Ueber den Einfluss von Neutralsalzen auf die Zuckerbildung in der Leber [Munster] 14p. 21cm. Bottrop, W. Postberg, 1936. HOHENBERG, Erich, 1908- *Rectale Hedonalnarkose bei Sauglingen; mit Aufweckungs- versuchen durch Coramin, Ephetonin und Car- diazol [Freiburg] 18p. 8? Berl., H. Michel [1933] HOHENBERGER, Ernst, 1911- *Ueber angeborene Missbildungen der Niere, speziell die Hufeisenniere. 23p. 21cm. Wiirzb., C. J. Becker, 1938. HOHENNER, Otto, 1909- *Ueber die Erythrocytengrosse bei Lungentuberkulose und ihre prognostische Bedeutung [Wurzburg] 17p. 8? Forchheim, O. Mauser, 1936. HOHENREIN, Wilhelm, 1896- *Ueber Spatfolgen der abdominalen Schnittentbindung unter besonderer Berucksichtigung der Uterus- ruptur; eine literarische Studie auf Grund des Schrifttums der Jahre 1910-31. 72p. 5 tab. 8? Wiirzb., R. Mayr, 1932. HOHENSCHILD, Margarete, 1900- *Ulcus ilei perforatum nach Paratyphus [Miin- chen] 19p. 8? Liibeck, Gebr. Hohenschild, 1927. HOHENTHAL, Erich, 1912- *Ueber das Vorkommen der Tuberkulose im Gottinger Sektionsgut von 1883-1932 [Giittingen] 14p. 22^cm. Wiirzb., K. Triltsch, 1937. HOHENZOLLERN family. Le Queux, W. Love intrigues of the Kaiser's sons. 320p. 8? N. Y., 1918. Heine. Totenmasken der Hohenzollern Friedrich des Grossen, seines Vaters, Grossvaters und Urgrossvaters. Zschr. ges. Anat., 2. Abt., 1932-33, 17: 635-40. HOHL, Fritz, 1909- *Die Vererbung der Eckzahngrosse. 12p. 8? Weende, A. F. Pieper, 1934. HOHL, Hans. *Untersuchungen iiber den Wert der Interferometrie als serologische Dia- gnose der Graviditat und verschiedener Erkran- kungen des weiblichen Genitale [Zurich] 29p. 8? Bern, Stampfli & cie, 1927. HOHL, Rudolf, 1909- *Ueber Eisen- phosphatablagerungen in der Magenwand und im Netz infolge Durchtritts eiserner Fremd- korper. 19p. 8? Kiel, W. Starke, 1935. HOHLBAUM, Harald, 1912- *Ein Bei- trag zur Frage der kongenitalen Tuberkulose [Leipzig] 18p. 8? Zeulenroda, A. Oberreuter, 1937. HOHLFELD, Edgar, 1903- *Die Be- deutung der Citocholreaktion nach Sachs- Witebsky fiir die Serodiagnose der Syphilis [Freiburg] 16p. 8? Kiel, K. J. Rossier, 1930. HOHLFELD, Kurt [Hugo Herbert] 1889- *Zur Pathologie des Milzbrandes; Beobachtungen HOHLFELD 748 HOJDA an vier Fallen des Instituts. 39p. 8? Bresl. [n. pub.] 1929 HOHLFELD, Martin, 1872- Editor of Klose, E. Kinderheilkunde. 18. Aufl. 255p. 21cm. Berl., 1939. See also Fruhwald, Richard, Hohlfeld, Martin [et al.] Diagnostisch-therapeutisches Vademecum. 27. Aufl. 684p. 16! Lpz., 1937. Also Klose, Erich, & Hohlfeld. Martin. Kinderheilkunde. 15. Aufl. 262p. 8? Berl., 1934. HOHMANN [August] Karl Heinz, 1911- *Storungen der Funktion des Kiefergelenks [Munchen] 19p. 8? Diisseld., G. H. Nolte, 1935. HOHMANN, Cornelia Euphrosyne Jakobine, 1894- *Ueber Erkennen und Behandeln von Spat- und Dauerschaden nach Gehirnent- ziindung Jugendlicher; beobachtet in der Heil- und Pflegeanstalt zu Ansbach. 22p. 21cm. Erlangen, K. Dores, 1937. HOHMANN, Georg, 1880- Die Pseud- arthrosen und die durch Knochendefekte ent- standenen Schlottergelenke. 4 p. 1. 61p. 8? Stuttg., F. Enke, 1921. Forms Bd 5, Deut. Orthop. (H. Gocht) ---- Fuss und Bein; ihre Erkrankungen und deren Behandlung. viii, 182p. 17 pl. 25,;Icm. Munch., J. F. Bergmann, 1923. Also 2. Aufl. x, 380p. illust. 1934. Also 3. Aufl. vii, 462p. illust. 1939. -—— Orthopadische Apparate und Bandagen; aus Klinik und Werkstatt. 74p. 8? Stuttg., F. Enke, 1936. Forms Beih. 64, Zschr. orthop. Chir. ----& STUMPF, Lina. Orthopadische Gymnastik. 156p. illust. 8? Lpz., G. Thieme, 1933 HOHMANN, Erika, 1909- Verglei- chende Untersuchungen iiber die Zuverlassigkeit der Rontgenkontrolle verschiedenartig wurzel- gefiillter Zahne, durchgefiihrt an aufgehellten Zahnwurzeln und Rontgenaufnahmen. 28p. 8? Bonn, H. Trapp, 1933. HOHMANN, Kurt, 1902- *Prognose der Dementia praecox. 17p. 8? Konigsb., J. Raabe, 1933. HOHMANN, Udo, 1901- *Carcinom- haufigkeit auf dem Boden des Lupus vulgaris (eine Zusammenstellung der Falle der Universi- tats-Haut klinik zu Munster) [Munster] 28p. 8? Straelen, P. Keuck, 1935. HOHN, Hans. Chemische Analysen mit dem Polarographen. vii, 102p. illust. tab. 8? Berl., J. Springer, 1937. Forms Bd 3, Anleitungen Chem. Laboratoriumsprajus CE. Ziutl) HOHN, Johannes, 1900- *Das Problem der schmerzlosen Zahnbehandlung. 23p. 8? Bresl. [L. Freund] 1929. HOHN, Wilhelm, 1911- *Gibt es eine Zunahme der weiblichen Geburten in den patri- zischen Familien Bremens? [Munchen] 22p 22^cm. Wiirzb., R. Mayr, 1937. HOHNECK, Jakob, 1908- *Beitrage zur Kenntnis der Unterfunktion hypophysarer Er- krankungen. 13p. 8? Wiirzb., R. Mayr, 1934. HOHNER, Paul, 1900- *Ueber Erfah- rungen mit dem Pernoctondammerschlaf in der Geburtshilfe; klinische und experimentelle Unter- suchungen. 30p. 8? Tub., E. Gobel, 1931. HOHNHOLD, Martin, 1907- *Ueber die Erythrozytensedimentierungsgeschwindigkeit bei Thyreotoxikose [Marburg] 16p. 8? Diisseld., G. H. Nolte, 1935. HOHNHOLZ, Hermann, 1886- * Aortitis luetica. 2Sp. 2 1. Rostock, Adlers Erben, 1919. HOJDA, Max, 1908- *Der Zahnarzt im Dienste der Sportmedizin. 46p. 8? Lpz., A Edelmann, 1932. HOKE, Michael, 1874- [Biography] Phi Chi Q., Menasha, 1935, 32: 227, purti. HOKE, R. J., & SCHMITH, O. Grundlagen und Methodik der Leichtathletik; eine Ein- fiihrung in die Leichtathletik fiir Studenten, Lehrer und Aerzte. vi, 225p. illust. 8? Lpz., J. A. Barth, 1937. HOKKAIDO Imperial University. The semi- centennial of the Hokkaido Imperial University, Japan, 1876-1926. 3 1. 210p. pl. portr. map. 8? Sapporo, Jap., 1927. HOLADAY, Perry W., & STODDARD, George D. Getting ideas from the movies, viii, 102p. 8? N. Y., Macmillan Co., 1933. Bound with Motion pictures & youth (W. W. Charters) 1933. HOLAND, Harold, & PHILLIPS, James K. Tuberculosis mortality in Milwaukee County, 1935-37 compared with 1930-32. 2 p. 1. 43p. incl. tab. diagr. 22cm. Milwaukee, Wis., Anti- Tuberc. Ass., 1939. HOLARRHENA. Bakhsh, I. The pharmacological actions of conessine and iso-conessine. J. Pharm. Exp. Ther., 1936, 58: 373-92.— Bertho, A. Kurchi-Alkaloide; iiber die Gewinnung von Conessin und dessen Nebenbasen. Arch. Pharm., Berl., 1939, 277: 327-57.—Caius, J. F., & Mhaskar, K. S. A study of Indian plants; Holarrhena antidysenterica, Wall. Ind. J. M. Res., 1927, Mem. No. 6, Suppl., 1-61, 7 pl.—Chopra, K. N., Gupta, J. C. [et al.] Observations on the pharmacological action of conessine, the alkaloid of Holarrhena anti-dvsentericti. Ind. M. Gaz., 1927, 62: 132-40.—Ghosh, §., & Bose. I. B. Die Alkaloide der Rinde von Holarrhena antidvsciitericu (Kurchi bark) Arch. Pharm., Berl., 1932, 270: 100-8. HOLBECHE Trigoso, Manoel Maria. *En- venenamento pelo phosphoro. 63p. 12? Lisb. [n. pub.] 1876. HOLBOLL, Einer, 1865-1927. Hammer, K. Nekrolog. Acta tuberc. scand., 1926-27, 2: 281-3. HOLBOLL, Svend Aage. *Experimentelle studier over cyanbrinteforgiftningen. 118p. 8? Kbh., A. Busck, 1924. HOLBORN, Hajo, 1902- Ulrich von Hutten. 2 p. 1. 175p. 8? Lpz., Quelle & Mever, 1929. HOLBROOK, Arthur Tenney. Practical in- formation about the teeth; a book for the people. 200p. 16? Milwaukee, Wise. State Dent. Soc, 1879. ---- Edward Lorenze Holmes (obituary) lOp. portr. 8? [n. p., 19-?] HOLBROOK, Charles Werden, 1856-1933. Barker, C. [Biography] Proc. Connecticut M. Soc, 1934, 142: 299. HOLBROOK, Stephen Griggs, 1798-1875. [Biography] Ohio M. J., 1938, 34: 423. HOLBROOK, W. F. See Jones, G. W., Berger, L. B., & Holbrook. W. F. Carbon monoxide hazards from house heaters burning natural gas. 31p. 8? Wash., 1917. HOLBROOK, William Paul, 1898- [Biography] Southwest. M., 1941, 25: 120, portr. HOLCK, Harold H. G. Diet and efficiency; a 5-year controlled experiment on man. ix, 72p. 4 pl. 8? Chic, 111., Univ. Chicago Press [1929] HOLCOMB, Blair, 1894- , HOLCOMB, Roger, & BURNS, Edgar Murray. A diabetic notebook for the use of the patient. 132p. incl. illust. tab. diagr. form. 23^cm. Portland, Ore. [Arcady press, 1941] HOLCOMB, Richmond Cranston, 1874- A century with Norfolk Naval Hospital, 1830- 1930; a story of the oldest Naval Hospital, the HOLCOMB 749 HOLDT Medical Department of the Navy, and the prog- ress of medicine through the past 100 years. 543p. 8? Portsmouth, Va., Printcraft pub. co., 1930. ---- Who gave the world syphilis? the Hai- tian myth. 189p. 8? N. Y., Froben press, 1937. HOLCOMB, Roger, 1897- See Holcomb, B., Holcomb, R., & Burns, E. M. A diabetic notebook for the use of the patient. 132p. 23J^cm. Portland, Ore., 1941. HOLDEFER, Wilhelm, 1904- *Die Be- festigungsmoglichkeiten bei totalen Prothesen [Erlangen] 49p. 8? Hof, H. Schmalzlein, 1931. HOLDEN, Austin, 1854-1903. Obituary. Q. Harvard M. Alumni Ass., 1901-4, 710. HOLDEN, Frances, 1899- *A study of the effect of starvation upon behavior by means of the obstruction method [Columbia Univ.] 45p. 8? Bait. [n. pub.] 1926. HOLDEN, Francis R[ichard] 1907- See McCord, Carey P., Holden, F. R., & Johnston, J. The basophilic aggregation test for lead absorption [&c.l 15 1. 8° Cincin., 1935. HOLDEN, Frederick Clark, 1868- Child spacing. 2 1. 23cm. [N. Y., Am. Birth Control League, 1931] Repr. from Birth Control Rev., March, 1931. ---- The same. [4]p. 23^cm. N. Y., Birth Control Fed. America, 1940. HOLDEN, Havrah. Up to date health manual; understandable, valuable, economical, practical farts, food, fast and excellent formulae. 47 1. 1? Phoenix, Republic & Gazette print. [1932] HOLDEN, Henry. An A B C of foot trouble and some remedies! 27 numb. 1. illust. 20cm. [Lond., The Author, 1909?] HOLDEN, Henry. Why is this so? a concen- sus of qualified opinion upon a cause of pelvic dis- ease. 2. ed. 60p. 12? Guildford, Biddle & son, 1912. Bound in Papers on cancer (F. L. Hoffman) 1904-14. HOLDEN, Margaret, 1893- *The nature and properties of the virus of herpes. 19p. 8? N. Y., Am. M. Ass. press, 1932. HOLDEN, Ward Andrews, 1866-1937. Collins, J. Obituary. Arch. Ophth., Chic, 1937, 17: 916- 19, portr.—Knapp, A. Obituary. Tr. Am. Ophth. Soc, 1937, 26-8, portr. HOLDENER, Albert. *Sympathische Er- krankung des zweiten Auges nach rechtzeitiger Enukleation des verletzten ersten Auges [Zurich] 16p. 8? Basel, B. Schwabe & co., 1930. Also Schweiz. med. Wschr., 1930, 60: 896-900. HOLDER, E. J. Surgical sutures and ligatures viii, 64p. illust. 18^cm. Edinb., E. & S. Livingstone, 1939. HOLDER, Eugene Michel, 1869- [Biography] Mississippi Doctor, 1941-42, 19: 461, portr.— K., E. G. Dr Eugene Michel Holder, President, Memphis and Shelby County Medical Society. Memphis M. J., 1942, 17: 2, portr. HOLDER, J. T. Elementary histological technique for animal and plant tissues, vii, 104p. pl. 8? Lond., J. & A. Churchill, 1931. HOLDERRIED, Paul, 1903- *Beitrage zur photodynamischen Wirkung (Wirkung fluores- zierender Stoffe) [Miinchen] 25p. 8? Mark- dorf, W. Fleck, 1929. HOLDHEIM, Harald, 1910- *Die Wir- kung des Hirseeiweisses auf die Lage der Harn- quotienten C:N und Vacat-0:N. 19p. 23cm. Berl. [n. pub.] 1937. HOLDSWORTH, Frank John, 1875-1935. Obituary. Tr. Am. Acad. Ophth. Otolar., 1935, 40: 476. HOLDT, Karl [Traugott Julius] 1902- *Die Verengerungen des Harnleiters [Konigs- berg] 21p. 8? Borna-Lpz., R. Noske, 1927. HOLE, James. The homes of the working classes, with suggestions for their improvement. xiv p. 214p. front. 21 pl. 8? Lond., Long- mans, Green & co., 1866. HOLE, John, 1755-1813. Memorial for Dr John Hole, first physician of the Miami Valley, dedicated at Centerville ceremonies on Mav 31. Ohio M. J., 1940, 36: 777-9. HOLFELDER, Hans, 1891- Die Ront- gentiefentherapie. viii, 341p. illust. pl. tab. diagrs. 25^cm. Lpz., G. Thieme, 1938. For portrait see Umschau, 1941, 45: 269. ---- HOLTHUSEN, H. [et al.] Ergebnisse der medizinischen Strahlenforschung (Rontgen- diagnostik, Rontgen- Radium- und Licht- therapie) v. 1-4. 4? Lpz., G. Thieme, 1925-28. HOLFERT, Johan. Volkstumliche Namen der Arzneimittel, Drogen und Chemikalien; eine Sammlung der im Volksmunde gebrauchlichen Bennennungen und Handelsbezeichnungen. 9. Aufl. bearb. von G. Arends. vi, 283p. 8? Berl. J. Springer, 1922. HOLGER, Jacobaeus, 1865-1934. Kuhn, J. [Obituary] Ugeskr. laeger, 1935, 79: 70.—T. Obituary] Hospitalstidende, 1935, 78: 141. HOLINGER, Jacques, 1865-1934. [Biography] Tr. Am. Otol. Soc, 1934, 24: 35; 1935, 25: 425, portr. HOLISM. See also Mind and Body. Allesch, J. von. Die Begriffe Ganzheit und Eigenschaft. Arch. ges. Psychol., 1939, 105: 36-57—Alverdes, F. Kau- salitat, Finalitat unci Ganzheit. Acta biotheor., Leiden, 1937, 3: 167-80.—Biinning, E. Kritische Betrachtungen zum Holis- mus. Ibid., 1935, 1: 173-84.—Driesch, H. Zur Kritik des Holismus. Ibid., 185-202.—Leemann, A. C. Les fondements scientifiques de l'holisme. Ibid., 1937, 3: 153-66.—Meyer, A. Die kausale Bedeutung des Holismus. Sudhoffs Arch., 1934-35, 27: 465.------Zwischen Scylla und Charybdis; holistische Antikritik von Mechanismus und Vitalismus. Acta biotheor., Leiden, 1935, 1: 203-18. HOLL, Charles Alfred, 1908- *L'atelec- tasie au cours de la tuberculose pulmonaire. 54p. 8? Strasb., Impr. Speciale, 1936. HOLL, Ferdinand, 1907- *Wirkung von Atropin und Nikotin auf den Kohlehydratstoff- wechsel [Munster] 16p. 8? Bottrop, W. Postberg, 1934. HOLLAENDER, Alfred, 1899- *Die Bedeutung des Spirochaeten-Nachweises bei sekundarer Syphilis. 40p. 8? Bonn, E. Eisele, 1921. HOLLAENDER, Arthur, 1902- Con- tribution a l'etude des operations mutilantes dans la coxalgie fistulisee grave; expose d'une technique nouvelle. 89p. 8? Par., Jouve & cie, 1927. HOLLAENDER, Erich, 1896- *Der Ein- fluss einiger Gewtirze auf die Magensaftsekretion. 27p. 8? Frankf. a. M., Mallet & Diirr, 1932. HOLLAENDER, Eugen, 1867- Die Kari- katur und Satire in der Medizin; medikokunst- historische Studie. xvi, 404p. 9 pl. 4? Stuttg., F. Enke, 1921. ---- Wunder, Wundergeburt und Wunder- gestalt in Einblattdrucken des fiinfzehnten bis achtzehnten Jahrhunderts. xvi, 373p. 202 illust. 4? Stuttg., F. Enke, 1921. ---- Anekdoten aus der medizinischen Welt- geschichte. x, 223p. 8? Stuttg., F. Enke, 1925. Also 2. Aufl. x, 224p. illust. portr. 8? 1931. ---- Aeskulap und Venus; eine Kultur- und Sittengeschichte im Spiegel des Arztes. vii, 488p. 4° BerL, Propylaen-Verl., 1928. HOLLAENDER HOLLA FNDER, Friedrich, 1912- * Ueber die Blutplattchen des menschlichen Blutes, insbesondere iiber die Ausfiihrung und den Ver- gleich von fiinf Bluttpliittchenzahlmethoden beim Kinde. 34p. 20>£cm. Bonn, H. Schnitzler, 1938. HOLLAIN, Joseph, 1900- *Meckelsches Divertikel und Ileus iStrangulationsileus) 16p. S? Bresl., K. Vater, 1925. HOLLAND, Arthur Lawrence, 1873- Indigestion; what it is and how to prevent it. vii, 129p. 8? N. Y., D. Appleton & co., 1926. HOLLAND, Bernard. Memoir of Kenelm Henrv Digby. viii, 251p. 8? Lond., Longmans, Green & co., 1919. HOLLAND, Charles Thurstan, 1864-1941. Barclay. A. E. [Obituary] Am. J. Roentg., 1941, 45: 926-8, portr. Also Nature, Lond., 1941, 147: 259.—Obituary. Brit. M. J., 1941, 1: 139, portr. Also Lancet, Lond., 1941, 1: 165, portr.—R., E. R. Obituary. Brit. J. Radiol., 1941, 14: 94, portr. HOLLAND, Eardley Lancelot, 1879- Causation of foetal death, viii, 159p. 24 pl. 8? Lond., H. M. Stat. Off., 1922. Forms No. 7, Rep. Pub. Health & Med. Subj. Ministry of Health. See also Eden, Thomas Watts, & Holland, Eardsley. A manual of midwifery. 6. ed. 704p. 8? Lond., 1925. ------ A manual of obstetrics. 8. ed. 765p. 8? Lond., 1937. — JEWESBURY, R. C, & SHELDON, Wilfrid. A doctor to a mother; the management of maternal and infant health. 96p. 8? Lond., I-;. Arnold & co. [1933] HOLLAND, Eardley L., & LANE-CLAYPON, Janet E. Child life investigations; a clinical and pathological study of 1673 cases of dead-births and neo-natal deaths. 94, vi p. 8? Lond., H. M. Stat. Off., 1926. Porms No. 109, Gr. Britain Privy Counc. M. Res. Counc. Spec. Rep. Ser. HOLLAND, Heinrich, 1908- *Ein Bei- trag iiber entzundliche Pankreaserkrankungen [Bonn] 32p. 8? Esseh-Altenessen, J. Heine- mann, 1933. HOLLAND, James William, 1849-1922. Urine and clinical chemistry of the gastric contents, the common poisons, and milk. 7. ed. x, 172 1. 12? Phila., P. Blakiston's son & co., 1904. HOLLAND, Meta, 1888- Vor dem Tore der Ehe; was jede junge Frau wissen muss. 279p. pl. 8? Konstanz i. B., Christl. Ver- lagsanst, [1936] HOLLAND, Philemon, 1552-1637. Silvette, H. A short-title list of the writings of Philemon Holland of Coventry, doctor of phvsicke. 18p. 8? University, Va., 1939. [Biography] Ann. M. Hist., 1941, 3. ser., 3: 83. For portrait, photograph of a pencil drawing after \V. Marshall's engraving, see Collection in library. HOLLAND, Werner, 1910- *Klinische und histologische Untersuchungen der Pulpa- amputation unter besonderer Beriicksichtigung von Pulpatoxin [Wurzburg] 16p. 8? Ochsen- furt, Fritz & Rappert, 1935. HOLLAND. See Netherlands. HOLLANDER, Bernard, 1864- Brain, mind, and the external signs of intelligence. 288p. 24 pl. 8? Lond., G. Allen & Unwin [1931] ---- Old age deferred; the prevention of the disabilities and diseases of old age. ix, 102p. 8? Lond., Watts & co. [1933] ---- Methods and uses of hypnosis and self- hypnosis; a treatise on the powers of the sub- conscious mind. 191p. 12? Lond., G. Allen & Unwin [1935] HOLLANDER HOLLANDER, Klaus, 1909- *Eklampsic und Wetter. 19p. 3 ch. 8? Konigsb., J. Raabe 1934. HOLLANDER, Walther von. Der Mensch iiber Vierzig; neuer Lebensstil im neuen Lebens- alter. 223 [l]p. 20cm. BerL, Deut. Veil [1938] HOLLAND-LETZ, William, 1912- *Ueber den Stridor congenitus [Jena] 17p. 21cm Wiirzb., K. Triltsch, 1937. HOLLAND-MORITZ, Otto, 1909 ♦Ver- suche zum Nachweis der antiexsudativen Wir- kung des Calciums. 24p. 21 cm. Tiib., Bolzle, 1936. HOLLANDS, Josef, 1910- *Ueber die Arbeitsweise bei der Uhlenhuthschen Eiweiss- bestimmung. 34p. 8? Giessen, Nitchkowski, 1937. HOLLATZ, Max [Friedrich Alexander] 1893 *Ueber den Catarrhus aestivus und seine Behandlung (Erfahrungen aus dem eigenen Leiden) [Halle] 30p. 8? Grafenhainichen, ('. Schuize & co., 1926. HOLLBORN, Rudolf, 1898- *Statistische Uebersicht iiber die an der Medizinischen Uni- versitatsklinik zu Leipzig in den Jahren 1910 bis 1927 beobachteten Falle von Lymphogranulo- matose [Leipzig] 84p. 8? [Zeulenroda, A. Oberreuter] 1928. HOLLE, Hermann Gustav, 1888- Allge- meine Biologie als Grundlage fiir Weltanschauung, Lebensfiihrung und Politik. 2. Aufl. 367p. 8? Munch., J. F. Lehmann, 1925. HOLLE, Horst, 1908- *Untersuchungen iiber die Atherosklerose und Mediaverkalkung bei fiinf Fallen von Extremitatengangran. 21p. 8? Wurzb., F. Scheiner, 1937. HOLLEDERER, Paul, 1902- ♦Patho- logische Leberveranderungen bei Mausen nach Infektion mit Paratyphus. 29p. 6 tab. 8? Erlangen, K. Dores, 1927. HOLLEFELD, Ludwig, 1876- *Die Ge- schichte der Stiftzahne (Auszug) 8p. 8? Bonn, J. F. Carthaus, 1921. HOLLENBACK, George M. Amalgam and its manipulation, p.150-93. 21cm. N. Y., Nat. Med. Book Co., 1938. In Oper. Dent. (C. N. Johnson) N. Y., 1938. HOLLENBECK, Stanley W. *Blood trans- fusions; history, indications and reactions— review of cases in 1934-35. 22p. 8? Milwaukee, Wise, 1936. Typewritten. HOLLENDER, Abraham Risel, 1892- Physical therapy in diseases of the eye, ear, nose and throat; with chapters on some borderline affections, xvii, 307p. 8? N. Y., Macmillan co., 1926. ---- The same. English ed. xvii, 307p. 8? Lond., J. & A. ChurchiU, 1926. ---- Physical therapeutic methods in oto- laryngology. 2p.; 442p. illust. 8? S. Louis, C. V. Mosby co., 1937. HOLLENSTEINER, Gottfried [Wilhelm Karl] *Ueber Atresia ani [Kiel] 51p. 8? Coburg, A. Rossteutscher, 1936. HOLLER, Blasius. Medicae artis theorica. 325p. 12? Strassburg, P. Machaeropoeus, 1564. HOLLER, Rudolf [Arthur] 1910- *Blut- druckmessungen an Pferden nach geringen Gaben von Chloralhydrat. 51p. 21cm. Lpz., A. Edelmann, 1936. HOLLER, Werner [Karl Heinrich] 1910- *Ueber das Vorkommen von mausepathogenen HOLLER 751 HOLLMAN Pneumokokken im Speichel bei erkalteten und nicht erkalteten Menschen [Leipzig] 16p. 8? Zeulenroda, A. Oberreuter, 1933. HOLLERBACH, Heinrich, 1906- *Queck- silberintoxikation in der Zahnheilkunde [Heidel- berg] 18p. 8? Ludwigshafen, J. Langenstein, 1933 HOLLERS, James T., 1899- Biography. Dent. Bull., Carlisle, 1941, 12: 48-50, portr. HOLLEVILLE, Jean Marie, 1913- ♦Trou- bles trophiques apparaissant apres la reduction des luxations congenitales de la hanche. 75p. 25cm. Par., L. Arnette, 1939. HOLLEY, Clifford Dyer, & LADD, E. F. Analysis of mixed paints, color pigments and varnishes, xiii, 235p. pl. 8? N. Y., J. Wiley & sons, 1908. HOLLEY, James Arthur, 1854- The recollections of a country doctor. 126p. pl. 2 portr. 21cm. Bost., Meador pub. co., 1939. HOLLICK, Frederick. Male generative or- gans in health and disease; being a complete practical treatise on the anatomy and physiology of the male system [&c] 200. ed. xi, 466p. 16? N. Y., Am. News co., 1877. ----Popular treatise on venereal diseases, in all their forms, embracing their history and probable origin; their consequences, both to individuals and to society; and the best modes of treating them. 50. ed. vii, 407p. 16? N. Y., Am. News co., 1881. ----Matron's manual of midwifery and the diseases of women during pregnancy and in child bed [&c] x, 466p. 16? N. Y., Excelsior pub. house, 1890. HOLLIDAY, C. B. See Le Rossignol, J. N., & Holliday, C. B. A pharmacopoeia for chiropodists. 160p. 8? Lond., 1937. HOLLIDAY, Houghton. Dental radiology handbook, x p. 1. 120p. illust. portr. diagrs. 8? N. Y., Macmillan co., 1935. HOLLIER Larousse, Julia F., 1908- ♦Les dyspnees chez le nouveau-ne\ 74p. 8? Par., E. Le Francois, 1936. HOLLINGSWORTH, Helen, MONROE, Day [et al.] Family expenditures for medical care; 5 regions, viii, 241p. 23cm. Wash., Gov. Print. Off., 1941. Forms No. 402, Misc. Pub., U. S. Dep. Agr. HOLLINGSWORTH, John B., 1873-1941. [Obituary] Canad. J. Comp. M., 1941, 5: 332. HOLLINGWORTH, Harry Levi, 1880- The psychology of thought, approached through studies of sleeping and dreaming, xvii, 329p. 8? X. Y., D. Appleton & co., 1926. ---■ Mental growth and decline; a survey of developmental psychology, xii, 396p. 8? N. Y., D. Appleton & co., 1927. ---Psychology; its facts and principles. xviii, 539p. 8? N. Y., D. Appleton & co., 1928. ---- Abnormal psychology; its concepts and theories, xi, 590p. 8? N. Y., Ronald press co. [1930] For portrait see J. Consult. Psychol., 1940, 4: No. 6, front. ---& POFFENBERGER, A. T. Applied psychology, xiii, 337p. 8? N. Y., D. Appleton & co., 1918. HOLLINGWORTH, Leta [Stetter] 1886-1939. Gifted children, their nature and nurture. xxiv, 374p. 8? N. Y., Macmillan co., 1926. For biography see Am. J. Psychol., 1940, 53: 299-301 (A. T. Poffenberger) HOLLMAN, Emile Clement Marie Joseph. *0ver de quantitatieve bepaling van morphine in opium. 4 p. 1. 92p. 2 1. 8? Amst., H. J. Pans, 1926. HOLLMANN, Hans, 1901- *Zur Frage der Mortalitat und Morbiditat bei Lues con- genita • [Bonn] 13p. 8? Stuttg. [n. pub.] 1927. HOLLMANN, Werner. Die Grundlagen der neuzeithchen Tuberkulosetherapie im Rahmen der allgemeinen Therapie innerer Erkrankungen. lOOp. 8? Lpz., J. A. Barth, 1937. Forms H. 65, Tuberk. Bibl. HOLLMANN-ZIMMERMANN, Margarete, 1907- ♦Ueber die Ependymitis granulans besonders die im Riickenmark [Heidelberg] 16p. 8? Diisseld., G. H. Nolte, 1934. HOLLMEYER, Hermann, 1911- ♦Un- tersuchungen iiber die Zahn- und Mundver- haltnisse der schulpflichtigen Kinder des Kreises Grafschaft Diepholz (West) [Munster] 36p. 21cm. Lengerich, 1938. HOLLOS, Jozsef, 1876- Immune-blood therapy of tuberculosis, with special references to latent and masked tuberculosis, xxv, 197p. fold, diagr. 22cm. N. Y., 1938. HOLLOWAY, Thomas Beaver, 1872-1936. McGuire, H. H. Memoir of Dr Thomas B. Holloway. Tr. Coll. Physicians Philadelphia, 1936-37, 4: p. xxiv-xxviii.— Obituary. Tr. Am. Acad. Ophth. Otolar., 1936, 41: 656. Also Arch. Ophth., Chic, 1937, 17: 147-50, portr. HOLLOWBRUSH, Joseph Ralston, 1860- 1927. Macrae, D., jr. [Obituary] Tr. West. Surg. Ass. (1927) 1928, 37: 525, portr. HOLLSTEIN, Hermann, 1903- ♦Stati- stische Beobachtungen iiber das Verhaltnis haufig vorkommender Hautkrankheiten zum Lebens- alter. 48p. 8? Gott. [n. pub.] 1928. HOLLSTEIN, Kurt, 1910- ♦Die Schwan- gerschafts-Schnellreaktion mit Hilfe reifer Mause [Gottingen] 31p. 8? Kassel-Wilhelmshohe, Thiele & Schwarz, 1934. HOLLSTEIN Schminke, Juan. ♦Contribu- ci6n al perfeccionamiento de la anestesia general eterea [Chile] 170p. diagr. 26cm. Nufioa, Impr. Jeneral Diaz, 1938. HOLLY. See Ilex. HOLLWECK, Anton, 1903- ♦Beitrag zur Lehre von den umschriebenen Geschwiilsten des Riickenmarks. 22p. 8? Munch., A. Huber [1932] HOLLWICH, Fritz, 1909- ♦Zur Frage der Entstehung des Conus myopicus nach Un- tersuchungen an Fallen von Keratitis parenchy- matosa. 14p. 21cm. Miinch., C. Wolf & Sohn, 1936. HOLM, Christian, 1871-1933. Kuhn, J. [Obituajy] Ugeskr. laeger, 1933, 95: 1251. HOLM, Edgar, 1877-1941. W., J. S. Obituary. CaUfornia West. M., 1941, 54: 288. HOLM, Gillis E[inar] Alexander] 1891-1927. Heme, A. T. [Obituary] Tskr. mil. halsov., 1927, 52: 152. HOLM, Helmut, 1909- ♦Ueber Tumoren und Cysten im Bereiche der Oberkieferhohle [Tubingen] 27p. 8? Bochum-Langendreer, H. Pbppinghaus, 1932. HOLM, Kurt. Laboratoriumstechnik in der Medizin; theoretische Grundlagen und prak- tische Ausfiihrung medizinischer, physikalischer und chemischer Untersuchungs-Methoden; Lehr- und Hilfsbuch fiir den Laboratoriumsdienst; bearbeitet von Dr H. Bennhold, Dr F. Bertram, [et al.] xii, 714p. 4 pl. illust. 8? Hamburg, P. Hartung [1931] HOLM i 52 HOLMES HOLM [Otto] Ejler, 1SS7- *Det gule maculapigment og dets optiske betydning [Ko- benhavn] 85p. 8° BerL, J. Springer, 1922. HOLM, Stig Johannes, 1902- *Les etats de la refraction oculaire chez les pal6n6grides au Gabon, Afrique Equatoriale Francaise; etude de race pour eclairer la genese de la refraction. 3 p. 1. 299p. incl. tab. diagr. pl. 23^cm. Lund, Impr. H. Ohlsson, 1937. ---- The same. 299p. 6 pl. 8? Kbh., Levin & Munksgaard, 1937. Forms Suppl. 13, Acta ophth. HOLMAN, Emile, 1890- Arteriovenous aneurysm; abnormal communications between the arterial and venous circulations, xvi, 244p. illust. diagrs. portr. 8? N. Y., Macmillan co., 1937. For portrait see Nu Sigma Nu Bull., 1940-41, 30: 170. HOLMAN, P. See Henshaw, E. M., Holman, P., & Langdon, J. N. Manual dexterity-effects of training [&c] 45p. 8? Lond., 1933. HOLMBERG, Adolfo D. Antecedentes, titu- los y trabajos. 20p. 23cm. B. Air., A. G. Buffarini, 1941. HOLMBERG, Linda. Ergebnisse optischer und chemischer Wasseranalysen, 1911-31. 54p. tali. 8? Helsin., Kirjapaino, 1935. HOLMES, Barbara. Cancer and scientific research, viii, 160p. 8? Lond., Sheldon press [1931] HOLMES, BAYARD, 1852-1924. Bibliography of Bayard Holmea. Med. Life, 1930, 37: 441-54. For portrait, photograph, see Collection in library. HOLMES, Benjamin Harrison, -1939. Obituary. Tr. Am. Acad. Ophth. Otol.-u., 1939, 415. HOLMES, Bettie Fleischmann, 1941. V., M. H. [Obituary] J. Med., Cincin., 1941-42, 22: 462-5, portr. HOLMES, Charles \V., 1874-1940. Tynan, M. I. An appreciation. Outlook for Blind, 1940, 34: 69-72, portr. HOLMES, Christian Rasmus, 1857-1920. Fischer, M. [11.1 Christian R. Holmes, man and physician. 233p. 29cm. Springf., 111., 1937. For portrait [photogiaph] see Wilder Collection in library. HOLMES, Dwight Oliver Wendell, 1877- ♦The evolution of the Negro college [Columbia Univ.] 221p. 8? N. Y., 1934. HOLMES, Edward Lorenzo, 1828-1900. Three cases of neuro-retinitis, with a symptom of intra-cranial aneurism. 8p. 8? [n. p., 187?] ---- Casuistische Mittheilungen. 3p. 8? Wiesbaden, J. F. Bergmann [1874] ----Clinical contributions, p. 167-170. 8? [n. p., n. pub.] 1881. For portrait, photograph, see Collection in library. See also Holbrook, A. T. [Obituary] lOp. portr. 8? [n. p., n. d.] HOLMES, Edward Morell, 1843- [Biography] In Gallerie hervorrag. Ther. & Pharmakogn. Gegenwart, Geneve, 1897, 253-60, portr.—Stellfeld, C. Holmes. Tribuna farm., Curitiba, 1942, 10: 5. HOLMES, Eric Gordon, 1897- The metabolism of living tissues. x, 235p. 12? Cambr. [Eng.] Cambridge Univ. press, 1937. HOLMES, Frances Baker, 1906- ♦An experimental study of the fears of voung children [Columbia Univ.] 299p. 8? N. Y.'[n. pub.] 1935. See also Jersild, Arthur Thomas, & Holmes, Frances Baker. Children's fears. 356p. 8? N. Y., 1935. HOLMES, Frank Lincoln Duane. A hand- book of voice improvement. [3] 74 1. 8? Madi- son, Wis., 1935. HOLMES, Fred Gooding, 1889- Tuber- culosis; a book for the patient, vii, 312p. 8? N. Y., D. Appleton-Century co., 1935. HOLMES, George Winslow, 1876- See Cancer; a manual for practitioners. 284p. 23Vcm. Kuala Lumpur, 1939. Forms pt of No. 2, Bull. Inst. M. Res. Malay, 1939. HOLMES, William Henry, 1846-1933. Tex- tile fabrics of ancient Peru. 17p. 8? Wash., Gov. Print. Off., 1889. Forms Bull. 7, Smithson. Inst. Bur. Am. Ethnol. Obituary. Am. Anthrop., 1933, 35: 752-64, portr. HOLMES, William Henry, 1887-1940. Bacil- lary and rickettsial infections, acute and chronic; a textbook, black death to white plague. 8 p. 1. 676p. diagr. 24cm. N. Y., Macmillan Co., 1940. For biography see Proc. Inst. M. Chicago, 1940-41, 13: 426, portr. (I. S. Cutter) Also Q. Bull. Northwest. Univ. M. School, 1940, 14: 313, portr. HOLMES, Winifred. First baby, xii, 177p. 19cm. Lond., Blackie & son [1939] HOLMGREN, Alarik Frithiof, 1831-97. Portrait. In Portr Sven. lak. apotek. (Sjoberg, N.) Stockh., 1910, 54. HOLMGREN, Hjalmar. Studien iiber 24- stundenrhythmische Variationen des Darm-, Lungen- und Leberfett: nebst Untersuchungen iiber die Morphologie der Fettresorption, des Leberfetts, des Leberglykogens und der Gallen- vorstadien, sowie iiber die 24-stundenrhythmi- schen Variationen im Gehalt des Pankreas an Zymogengranula. 202p. 26 pl. 8? Helsin., Mercator, 1936. Forms H. 74, Acta med. scand. HOLMGREN, Lennart. *Hearing tests and hearing aids; a clinical and experimental study. I62p. 2 diagr. 8? Stockh., Thule, 1939. Also Suppl. 34, Acta otolar., 1939. HOLMGREN, Nils Gunnar Frithiofsson, 1875- 1940. Bergstrand, H. [Sixty-fifth anniversary] Nord. med., 1940, 7: 1611, portr.—Burger, H. [Obituary] Acta otolar., Stockh., 1940, 28: 630-5, portr. HOLMGREN, Nils Frithiof, 1877- , & STENSIOE, Erik. Kranium und Visceralskelett der Akranier, Cyclostomen und Fische. p.233- 500. illust. 8? BerL, Urban & Schwarzenberg, 1936. In Handb. vergl. Anat. (Bolk, L. [et al.]) Berl., 1936, 4: HOLMIUM. See Earth metals, rare. HOLMS, Archibald Campbell, 1901- The facts of psychic science and philosophy collated and discussed, xvi, 512p. 8? Lond., Kegan Paul, Trench [et al.] 1925. HOLMYARD, Eric John, 1891- The great chemists, vi, 137p. 16? Lond., Methuen & co. [1928] See also Gabir. The works of Gabir; a new edition with introduction by E. J. Holmyard. 264p. 8? Lond., 1928. HOLOACARDIUS. See Acardius; Acephalus. HOLOCALYX. See also Leguminosae. Lucas. V. Sobre uma nova planta cianogenica; o alecrfm de campinas, Holocalyx glaziovii; Leguminosas. Rev. flora med., Rio, 1941, 8: 5-38.—Mucciolo, P. A prop6sito dos fenomenos de fotosensibilizacao. Rev. biol., S. Paulo, 1940-41, 11: 19-21. 227475—VOL. 7. 4th series----48 HOLODENKO, Leon, 1899- Contribu- tion a l'etude de l'azot6mie au cours de l'6clampsie convulsive de la gestation et de la puerpe>alite\ 51p. 8? Par., M. Vign6, 1927. HOLOMETRA. See Opistorchiidae. HOLOPEDIUM. Tauson, A. Die Abhangigkeit der Verbreitung von Holo- pedium gibberum Zadd. von einigen Faktoren des ausseren Mediums. Arch. Entwmech., 1931-32, 125: 770-99. HOLOSTOMUM. See Hemistomum. HOLOTHUROIDEA. See also Echinodermata. Frankel, S., & Jellinek, C. Ueber essbare Holothurien. Biochem. Zschr., 1927, 185: 389-91.—Panning, A. Ueber das optische Verhalten der Kalkkorper der aspidochiroten Holo- thurien. Zschr. wiss. Zool., 1928, 132: 95-104.—Uexkiill, J. yon. DieSperrmuskulaturderHoloturien. Arch, ges Phvsiol' 1926,212:1-14. i ' HOLOTRICHIDA. See under Ciliata. HOLSCHBACH, Josef, 1912- *Wie kom- men die Zahnmissbildungen bei Rachitis und kongenitaler Syphilis zustande? 28p. 22om Koln, J. Borowsky, 1936. HOLSENDORF, B. E. The rat and ratproof construction of buildings; with specifications, drawings, and photographs and a model rat- proofing ordinance. 68p. 2 pl. 8? Wash Gov. Print. Off., 1937. Forms Suppl. No. 131, Pub. Health Bep. See also Grubbs, S. B., & Holsendorf, B. E. The rat- proofing of vessels. 84p. 23cm. Wash., 1931. HOLST, Axel, 1861-1931. Fridericia, L. S. [Obituary] Hospitalstidende, 1931, 74: 939.—Looft, C. [Obituary] Med. rev., Bergen, 1931 47- 187-9. HOLST, Gunnar Moller, 1905- *Causale Studie iiber die Entstehung der menschlichen Schadelform. 34p. 3 pl. 8? Kiel, Schmidt & Klaunig, 1934. HOLST, Johannes Juul, 1903- *Ueber die Wanderung der Profilpunkte am menschlichen Schadel bei mannlichen Individuen wahrend der Lebensjahre 7, 14 und liber 20. 140p. tab. 8° Wiirzb., K. Triltsch, 1929. HOLST, Peter F„ 1861-1935. Editor of Laerebog i intern medicin [&c] V.l. 524p 8° Kbh., 1919. For Festschrift see Acta med. scand., 1931-32, 72: portr. For biography see Acta med. scand., 1935, 85: 493-8, portr. (O. Hanssen) Also Fin. lak. sail, hand., 1936, 79: 391-4, portr (R. Ehrstrom) Also Hygiea, Stockh., 1935, 97: 81-90, portr! (I. Holmgren) Also Norsk, mag. laegevid., 1935, 96: 214, portr. (O. Scheel) HOLST, W[alter] von. Marksteine in der Entwicklung der Medizin. 62p. 23cm. Danzig, A. W. Kafemann [1939] HOLSTE, Arnold, 1909- *Ueber die Kombination cerebraler Erkrankungen mit kon- genitalen Skelettanomalien im Kindesalter und ihre diagnostische Bedeutung. 28p. 22cm. Koln, J. Borowsky, 1936. HOLSTEIN, Eduard, 1905- *Ueber einen Fall von Chondrodystrophia foetalis. 16p. 8? Kiel [n. pub., 1930] HOLSTEIN, Ernst. See Baader, Ernst W., & Holstein, Ernst. Das Quecksilber [&c.] 239p. 8! Berl., 1933. HOLSTEIN, Georges, 1905- *Contribu- tion a la recherche des bacilles de Koch dans les excretions des chiens tuberculeux [Alfort] 62p. 8? Par., Presses Modernes, 1929. HOLSTRAETER 754 HOLTHOEFER HOLSTRAETER, Wilhelm, 1906- *Das Oberlippen-Carcinom. 31p. 8? Kiel, Schmidt & Klaunig, 1933. HOLT, Anne, 1899- A life of Joseph Priestley; with an introduction by Francis W. Hirst, xviii, 221p. portr. 8? Lond., Oxford Univ. press, 1931. HOLT, G. W. C. See Ellerman, J. R. The families and genera of living rodents. 8! Lond., 1940. HOLT, J. G. H. Marriage and periodic abstinence; the natural method of scientific family regulation, vii, 174p. illust. tab. ch. 8? Lond., Longmans, Green & co. [1937] HOLT, J. M. Cookery and nutrition [2. ed.] xii, 250p. 19cm. Lond., G. Bell & sons [1939] HOLT, Luther Emmett, sr, 1855-1924. Care and feeding of children. 2. ed. 104p. 16? N. Y., D. Appleton & co., 1897. Also 3. ed. 261p. 1926. Also 14. ed. xi, 259 [8]p. 1930. Also 15. ed. xi, 259 [8]p. diagrs. 12? N. Y., D. Appleton-Century co., 1935. ---- The diseases of infancy and childhood, for the use of students and practitioners of medicine. 9. ed. xiv, 1018p. 5 pl. 25cm. N. Y., D. Appleton & co., 1926. Also 10. ed. Revised by L. Emmett Holt, jr, and Rustin Mcintosh. xix, 1240p. illust. pl. diagrs. [1933] Also 11. ed. xxiv p. 2 1. 1421p. illust. 7 col. pl. diagr. [1940] See also Duffus. R. T.,&Holt, L. E. L. Emmett Holt; pioneer of a children century. 295p. 21cm. N. Y., 1940. Also L. Emmett Holt, popularizer of pediatrics in America. Clin. M. & S.. 1939, 46: 1, portr.—Haynes, R. S, Unveiling of memorial tablet to L. Emmett Holt, Bull. N. York Acad. M., 1929, 2. ser., 5: 557-60, portr. HOLT, Luther Emmett, jr, 1895- See Duffus, R. L., & Holt, L. E. L. Emmett Holt. 295p. 21cm. N. Y., 1940. Also Holt, Luther Emmett, sr. The care and feeding of children. 13. ed. 261p. 16? N. Y.. 1926. ------ The same. 15. ed. 259p. 1935. ■------& Howland, John. Holt's diseases of infancy and childhood. 10. ed. 1240p. 8? N. Y. [1936] HOLTEN, Cai, 1894- *The respiratory metabolism in diabetics and the influence of insulin upon it. 77p. 7 ch. 8? Kbh., Levin & Munksgaard, 1925. HOLTERMUELLER, Karl, 1910- *Die Lokalisation von traumatisehen Epiphysenlo- sungen der langen Rohrenknochen. 46p. ch. 8? Bonn, P. Kubens, 1934. HOLTGRAVE, Rudolf, 1906- lnter- suchungen iiber den kulturellen Nachweis von Tuberkelbakterien im menschlichen Blut [Diis- seldorf] 16p. 8? Tub., E. Gobel, 1933. HOLTH, Sdren, 1863-1937. Greco-Roman and Arabic bronze instruments and their medico- surgical use. 20p. 4 pl. 27cm. Kristiania, J. Dybwad, 1919. For biography see Acta ophth., Kbh., 1938, 16: 1, portr. (H. G. A. Gjessing) Also Arch. Ophth., Chic, 1937, 18: 1022, portr. Also Brit. M. J., 1937, 2: 998. Also Brit. J. Ophth., 1937, 21: 668a-70, portr. Also Fin. lak. sail, hand., 1938, 81: 201, portr. (S. Werner) Also Norsk, mag. laegevid., 1937, 98: 1443 (H. Lystad) HOLTHAUSEN, Lotte, 1906- *Ueber die Frage des Zusammenhanges zwischen psychi- schen Veranderungen bei Hirntumoren und deren Lokalisation. 43p. 8? Konigsb., J. Raabe, 1932 HOLTHAUSEN, Paul, 1876-1931. Nobbe. Nekrolog. Psychiat. neur. Wschr., 1931, 33: 349-51. HOLTHOEFER, Hugo. Gesetzgebung iiber Milch und Milcherzeugnisse. p.488-579. 25^cm. BerL, J. Springer, 1936. In Handb. Lebensmittelchem. (A. Bomer, et al.) Bd 3. ----Gesetzgebung iiber Fleipch und Fhisch- erzeugnisse. p.O'ifi -1013. 25^cm. BerL, J. Springer, 1936. In Handb. Lebensmittelchem. (A. Bomer, et al.) Bd 3. ---- Deutsche Gesetzgebung. p.856~969 25'^cm. BerL, J. Springer, 1938. In Handb. Lebensmittelchem. (A. Bomer) Bd 5. ---- Deutsche Gesetzgebung iiber Wein. p.448-537. 25^cm. BerL, J. Springer, 1938. In Handb. Lebensmittelchem. (A. Bomer) Bd 7. HOLTHUSEN, Hans, 1908- *Beitrag zur Organspezifitiit der Luesreaktionen [Mun- ster] 18p. 8? Bottrop, W. Postberg, 1935. HOLTHUSEN, Herman, 1886- See Dielrich, A., HoUhusen, H. [et al.] KrebsbehandluiiR und Krcbsbekampfung. 90p. 24cm. Berl., 1938. Also Haenisch, G. F., HoUhusen, H., & Liechti, A. Einfuhrung in die Rontgenologie [&c] 359p. 8? Lpz., 1933. Also Holfelder, Hans, HoUhusen, H. [et al.] Ergebnisse der medi- zinischen Strahlenforschung [&c] 4v. 4? Lpz., 1925-28. ---- & BRAUN, R. Grundlagen und Praxis der Rontgenstrahlen-dosierung: Dosismessung und Dosisfestsetzung. viii, 249p. illust. tab. diagrs. 8? Lpz., G. Thieme, 1933. HOLTKAMP, Hermann [Heinrich] 1902- *Ueber den Einfluss von phenyl- und halo- gensubstituierten Barbitursauren auf die Bildung und Spaltung von Phosphorsaurestern im Ge- webe. 15p. 8? Miinst., H. Buschmann, 1935. HOLTKOTT, Else, 1906- *Ueber die von 1896 bis 1930 im St Johannis-Hospital Bonn beobachteten Falle von Magenkarzinom. 32p. 8? Bonn, J. F. Carthaus, 1933. HOLTMAN, Darlington Frank. See Allen. P. W., Holtman, D. F., & McBee, L. A. Microbes which help or destroy us. 540p. 22^cm. S. Louis, 1941. HOLTMANN, Wilhelm, 1908- *Beitrage zur Gelenktuberkulose [Greifswald] 33p. 8? Quakenbruck, R. Kleinert, 1936. HOLTON, Charles W., 1882- [Biography] In Coll. Pharm. N. York (Wimmer, C. P.) N. Y., 1929, 253, portr. HOLTZ, Anders Gustav Folke, 1892- *Klinische Studien iiber die nicht tuberkulose Salpingo-Oophoritis (1262 Falle, von welchen 90.6% nach einer Beobachtungszeit von minde- stens 4 Jahren nachuntersucht sind) [Stock- holm] 209p. 8? Helsin. [n. pub.] 1930. HOLTZ, Elisabeth, 1898- *Ueber ent- lastende Mediastinotomie. 19p. 2 1. 8? [Miinch., P. Waizmann] 1928. HOLTZ, Harald, 1910- ^Vergleichende Untersuchungen iiber den Nachweis des Colige- halts in der Milch. 30p. 4 ch. 8? Giessen, O. Kindt, 1937. HOLTZ, Heinrich, 1912- *Zur Kenntnis seltener Falle der Tuberkulose des Gehirns und der Hirnhaute. 15p. 22cm. Rostock, G. Neumann, 1937. HOLTZ, Julius Friedrich, 1836- [Biography] In Gallerie hervorrag. Ther. Pharmakogn. Gegenwart, Geneve, 1897, 377-9, portr. HOLTZ, Jutta, 1901- *Abnorme Charak- tere bei Shakespeare: Othello, Richard III, Macbeth. 47p. 8? Tiib. [n. pub.] 1933. HOLTZ, Karl, 1898- *Theoretische Be- trachtungen zur Entwicklung und Rtickbildung, sowie zur Behandlung der Lahmungen bei der Heine-Medinschen Krankheit. 33p. 8? BerL [n. pub.] 1933. HOLTZ, Ulrich, 1908- *Neuere Ent- fernungsmethoden der Tatowierungen [Miin- chen] 24p. 8? Gutersloh, Thiele, 1936. HOLTZAPPLE 755 HOLZ HOLTZAPPLE, George E„ 1862- National Broadcasting Co., Inc. Danger fighters: New breath, episode No. 39. 25 1. 4? Nat'l. Broadcasting co. [n. d.] Mimeographed. See also First administration of oxygen gas in pneumonia, at Loganville, Pa., March 6, 1885; article appears in N. Y. Medical Journal Sept. 3, 1887 [Water color of the proceedings by Ralph Aulthouse. Rec'd in S. G. O. Library, February 1935] For portrait, photograph, see Collection in library. HOLTZER (ex-Hugo) Mme. See Pasteur Vallery-Radot, Mauric, G., & Holtzer, Mme. L'anaphylaxie. 130p. 25cm. Par., 1937. HOLTZHAUER, Jean, 1912- Contribu- tion a l'etude du sodoku. 47p. 24^cm. Par., M. Vigne, 1939. HOLTZMAN, Samuel George, 1911- *Patient und Wetter. 59p. 21cm. Munch., Hohenhaus, 1936. HOLTZMANN, Friedrich, 1876- See Beck, Karl, & Holtzmann, Friedrich. Larmarbeit und Ohr. 47p. 8? Berl., 1929. ----SCHNEIDER, L. [et al.] Die Bedeutung der Beleuchtung fiir Gesundheit und Leistungs- fahigkeit. 53p. 8? BerL, J. Springer, 1928. Forms Beih. 10, Zbl. Gewerbehyg. HOLVEY, Ervin Harvey, 1913- *Chole- cystic disease; a review of 102 consecutive cases. 42p. 4? Milwaukee, Wise, 1938. Typewritten MS. HOLYOKE, Mass. Board of Health. Annual report, Holyoke [14.] (1893/94-) 1895- HOLYOKE, Mass. House of Providence Hospital. Annual reports of the Sisters. Hol- yoke, 2.-3., 1896-98. HOLYOKE Association for Prevention and Relief of Tuberculosis. See Holyoke Tuberculosis Association. HOLYOKE City Hospital [*1891] Annual reports. Holvoke, 2.-5., 1895-98; 1910; 1912; 1914-15; 1917-21. --- Forty-four years of life saving. 23p. 12? [Holyoke] 1935. HOLYOKE Tuberculosis Association. Annual report. Holyoke (1907) 1908- HOLY WATER. Werz, E. * Ueber das Vorkommen pathogener und nichtpathogener Bakterien im Weihwasser und deren biologisches Verhalten nach der Rein- zuchtung (namentlich in kultureller Hinsicht und im Tierversuch) [Bern] 46p. 8? Miinch., 1907. H., L. L'hygiene dans les eglises. Ann. pharm., Louvain, 1900, 6: 436. HOLZ, Bernhard [Oskar Ernst Arthur] 1902- *Ueber Colitis ulcerosa. 39p. 8? Konigsb., E. Steinbacher, 1930. HOLZ, Hans Wilhelm, 1907- *Ueber Fehlerquellen beim Nachweis von Mikroor- ganismen im Nabelschnurblut unter besonderer Berucksichtigung der Benedek'schen Spalthefe- befunde [Munster] 14p. 8? Diisseld., G. H. Nolte, 1934. HOLZ, Hermann, 1912- *Ueber das Vorkommen von Tuberkelbazillen in der Mund- hohle Offentuberkuloser [Frankfurt] 23p. 8? Gelnhausen, F. W. Kalbfleisch, 1936. HOLZ, Use. *Versuch einer histonsch-knti- schen Darstellung der Pathogenese einiger toxi- scher Nervenkrankheiten in der Schwangerschaft [Basel] 45p. 8? Ohlau, H. Eschenhagen, 1935. HOLZ, Johannes, 1909- *Der Stereo- effekt Pulfrichs und die Empfindungszeit [Ro- stock] p.502-16. 8? Miinch., J. F. Lehmann, 1934. Also Zschr. Biol., 1934, 95: HOLZ, Lore [Elisabeth Margarete Karla] 1909- *Experimentell-psychologische Un- tersuchungen wahrend des Menstruationszykus. 24p. 8? Greifsw., H. Adler, 1934. HOLZ, Werner, 1911- *Beitrage zur Pathologie und Klinik der Duodenal- und Dunndarmdivertikel unter besonderer Beriick- sichtigung des letzten Dezenniums. 19p. 23cm. BerL, R. Pfau, 1937. HOLZACH, Hans. *Ueber die Behandlung der Pulpagangran nach der Methode von Bernard (Jontophorese) [Basel] 21p. 24^cm. BerL, Urban & Schwarzenberg, 1937. Also Zschr. Stomat., 1938, 36: HOLZAMMER, Hermann, 1907- *Nacken- flecke [Erlangen] 24p. 8? Scheinfeld, G. Weltz, 1933. HOLZAPFEL, Gustav Hubert, 1908- *Ueber die Haufigkeit der Krebse, Sarkome und Hirngeschwiilste im Gottinger Sektionsgut 1925- 1933. 23p. 21cm. Gott., M. Sass, 1935. HOLZAPFEL, Rudolf, 1902- *Gastro- enterostomie oder Resektion bei Ulcus ventriculi sive duodeni perforatum? [Kiel] 23p. 8? [Bielefeld, J. D. Koster Nachf., 1930] HOLZAPFEL, Wilhelm, 1906- *Dauer- schadigungen bei unkomplizierten Schadelbasis- bruchen. 24p. 8? Wiirzb., G. Grasser, 1933. HOLZBACH, Ernst, jr, 1910- *Ueber die Zurechnungs- und Geschaftsfahigkeit mala- riabehandelter Paralytiker. 36p. 21cm. Berl. [n. pub.] 1938. HOLZBERGER, Ludwig [Paul Johann] 1904- *Untersuchung iiber die Dauererfolge der operativen Behandlung des Ein- und Auswarts- schielens an der Augenklinik der Universitat Tubingen in den Jahren 1921-28. 32p. 8? Tub., C. Guide, 1930. HOLZER, Kurt, 1902- *Das Krank- heitsbild der Typhobazillose (nach Landouzy) p.245-57. 8? BerL, J. Springer, 1927. Also Beitr. Khn. Tuberk., 1927, 66: HOLZER, Wolfgang, & WEISSENBERG, Eugen. Foundations of short wave therapy; physics, technics, indications; transl. by Justina Wilson and Charles M. Dowse. 228p. illust. tab. diagrs. 8? Lond., Hutchinson [1935] HOLZGREVE, Bernhard, 1910- *Ueber das Zusammenwirken von Morphin und Skopol- amin auf die Sauerstoffzehrung [Munster] 15p. 20>^cm. Werne a. d. Lippe, F. Grube, 1936. HOLZHAUER, Artur [Hermann] 1907- *Futterungsversuche mit Trichinellen beim Hunde. 38p. 8? Lpz., A. Edelmann, 1933. HOLZHAUER, Wilhelm, 1909- *Zahn- arztliche Auswertung der Beobachtung der Zuckersprechstunde der medizinischen Klinik Bonn. 29p. 22cm. Bonn, H. Trapp, 1936. HOLZHAUSEN, Hans Georg, 1911- *Ueber die Wirkung aliphatischer und aro- matischer Derivate des /3-Phenylaethylamins [Kiel] 15p. 8? Gutersloh, Thiele, 1935. HOLZHAUSEN, Hans Joachim, 1906- *Die Aetiologie und die Therapie der isolierten Sehnen- und Nervenluxationen [Leipzig] 30p. 8? Zeulenroda, A. Oberreuter, 1933. HOLZHAUSEN, Max [Bernhard] 1913- *pH-Wert und Gesamtaciditat; vergleichende Untersuchungen am Magensaft gesunder und kranker Hunde nach Einwirkung des Alkohol- probefruhstuckes von Ehrmann. 43p. 8? Lpz., A. Edelmann, 1937. HOLZHAUSEN, Paul, 1901- *Physi- kalisch-chemische Veranderungen im Serum HOLZHAUSEN 756 HOLZMANN Krebskranker mit I'ntersuchungen der Verande- rungen des Gefrierpunktes. 18p. 8? Frankf. a. M., H. Munch., 1926. HOLZHEUER, Elisabeth, 1910- *For- men friihzeitigen Alterns (Picksche Atrophie) [Leipzig] 28p. 8° Zeulenroda, A. Oberreuter, 1934. HOLZINGER, Karl John, 1892- & SWINEFORD, Frances. Preliminary report on Spearman-Holzinger unitary trait study. No. 8: The estimation of a factor for an individual. 21p. tab. 4? Chic, Univ. Chicago, 1936. HOLZINGER, Walter, 1907- *Ein Bei- trag zur Kavitatenpraparation unter Verwendung der gebrauchlichsten Fullmaterialien [Wiirz- burg] 32p. 8? Stuttg., Holzinger & co., 1930. HOLZINGER, Wilhelm, 1907- *Ver- suche einer Klarung der Verfarbung von Amal- gamen. 24p. 8? Tiib., E. Gobel, 1930. HOLZKAEMPER, Karl Ernst, 1907- *Ueber die Angewohnung des Alkohols bei der weissen Maus. 21p. 8? Halle [n. pub.] 1932. HOLZKAMP, Hans Joachim, 1910- * Ueber die pharmakologische Wertbestimmung einiger Belladonnapraparate. lip. 8? Tiib. [n. pub.] 1935. HOLZKI, Werner, 1905- *Ueber In- vagination, unter besonderer Berucksichtigung der Ileocoecalinvagination und ihres Zusam- menhanges mit Mesenterium ileo-colicum com- mune. 67p. 8? Konigsb., J. Raabe, 1933. HOLZKNECHT, Guido, 1872-1931. Ein- stellung zur Rontgenologie; eine Untersuchung iiber die Einfiigung der Rontgenstrahlenanwen- dung in Praxis, Forschung und Unterricht. xii, 115p. 8? Wien, J. Springer, 1927. ----Handbuch der theoretischen und klini- schen Rontgenkunde. v. 1-2, 2v. xiv, 457p.; xii, 357p. 2 ch. 8? Wien, J. Springer, 1929-30. Beclere, A. Necrologie. J. radiol. dlectr., 1932, 16: 3, portr.-—Farago, S. [Obituary] Magy. rontg. kozl., 1931, 5: Nos 11-12.— Farreras, P. [Necrologio] Rev. espafi. med. cir., 1932, 15: 233.—Forssell. G. Nekrolog. Acta radiol., Stockh., 1931, 12: 516-21. Also Hygiea, Stockh., 1931, 93: 865-70.—Glasser, O. [Obituary] Am. J. Roentg.. 1932, 27: 114-7.—Kienbock, R. Nekrolog. Wien. klin. Wschr., 1931, 44: 1451. ------ Holzknecht semper vivus. Strahlenthera- pie, 1937, 58: 497, portr.—Klepetar, H. Die Maske. Wien. med. Wschr., 1932, 82: 571.—Lenk, R. Nekrolog. Strahlen- therapie, 1932, 43: 1-8.—Meisels, E. [Necrologie] Polski przegl. radjol., 1931, 6: 313-7, portr.—Nemenov, M. [Obitu- ary] Vest, rentg., 1932, 11: 5-7.—Schwarz, G. Guido Holz- knechts Arbeiten und Ziele. Wien. med. Wschr., 1932, 82: 132-4.—Spiegler, G. Erinnerung an Professor Dr Guido Holzknecht. Deut. Aerzte Ztg, 1932, 7: No. 343.------ Der grossen Personlichkeit Guido Holzknecht zur Erinnerung. Wien. med. Wschr., 1932, 82: 1507. HOLZKNECHT, Karl, 1901- *Ueber die Reaktion carzinomatoser Seren nach H. Kahn und Wigand nebst Versuchen zur Theorie dieser Proben. 20p. 8? Wiirzb., C. J. Becker, 1926. HOLZLOEHNER, Manfred, 1907- *Ueber die Behandlung von Lippenkarzinomen. 24p. 2 tab. 8? Marb., K. Euker, 1934. HOLZMAN, V. S. Editor of Problemy tuberkuleza. Moskva, No. 1-8,1937-41. HOLZMANN, Adolf, 1903- *Bernhard Mohr; was gab es in Wurzburg vor Virchow an pathologischer Anatomie und pathologisch-ana- tomischem Unterricht? [Wurzburg] p.531-73. 8? BerL, J. Springer, 1929. Also Virchows Arch., 1929, 272: HOLZMANN, Adolf, 1912- *Beitrag iiber Beziehungen zwischen Adamantinom und Follikularzyste [Frankfurt] 24p. 21cm. Bot- trop, W. Postberg, 1937. HOLZMANN, Erich, 1901- *Die Ent- wicklung des offentlichen Badewesens in den Kriegs- und Nachkriegsjahren. 7p. 8? Berl [n. pub.] 1926. Also VerofT. Deut. Ges. Yolksb&der, 1926, 7: HOLZMANN, Hans, 1899- *Splenome- galie durch ein Aneurysma arteriovenosum eines Milzgefasses [Heidelberg] 19p. 8? Walldorf, F. Lamade, 1930. HOLZMANN, M. Erkrankungen des Herzens und der Gefasse. p. 1416-1523. 27#cm. Lpz , G. Thieme, 1939. In Lehrb. Rontgendiagn. (H. R. Schinz [et al.]) 4. Aufl., Bd 2. HOLZMANN, Max. thrombose und Em- bolie an der Universitatsfrauenklinik Zurich wahrend der letzten 20 Jahre (Auszug) [Zurich] 16p. 8? Basel, B. Schwabe & Co., 1924. Also Schweiz. med. Wschr., 1924, 54: 569-73. HOLZMANN, Wfalter] *Die interokklusah Gelenkbahnmessung nach der Methode von Christensen in Verbindung mit dem Artikulator von Hanau. 50p. 8? Zur. [n. pub.] 1927. Also Schweiz. Mschr. Zahnh., 1927, 37: HOLZMANN, Walter, 1905- *Einfluss der radikalen Kieferhohlenoperation (nach Cald- vvell-Luc) auf das Zahnsystem [Frankfurt] p.1089-111. 8? BerL, J. Springer, 1931. Also Deut. Mschr. Zahnh., 1931, 49: HOLZMAYER, L[orenz] 1876- *I)ei neuzeitliche Stand der expektorierenden Methode in der praktischen Tiermedizin. 58p. 8? Lpz A. Edelmann, 1925. HOLZNER, Hans, 1912- *Sekundaic Kiefergelenkerkrankungen. 24p. 21cm. Munch., G. Lindner, 1938. HOM, Johannes, 1905- *Die Behand- lungserfolge bei angeborener Syphilis mit Spirocid im Vergleich zu denen mit Neosalvarsan. 49p. 8? Halle, O. Jung, 1931. HOMACK, Walter [Hermann] 1897- *Ueber das subjektive Abgrenzen von Intervallen [Jena] 31p. 8? Zeulenroda, B. Sporn, 1935. HOMAGK, Martin, 1912- *Beitrage zur klinischen Sonderstellung der Mukosus-Otitiw [Munchen] 24p. 8? Speyer, Pilger, 1939. HOMAN, Albert Alojzij, 1903- *Ueber chirurgische Behandlung bestimmter Zustande bei Tabes dorsalis. 30p. 8? BerL, R. Bruckhoff, 1932. HOMAN, George, 1849- Relation of the single tax to public health. 3p. 8? S. Louis, 1893. Cutting from WTeekly Courier, S. Louis, 1893. ---- Catalogue containing titles and certain data relative to publications and other work covering a period of more than 30 years. 7 1. 22^cm. S. Louis, 1916. HOMANN, Friedrich Wilhelm, 1907- *Ueber Agranulocytose nach Schwermetallbe- handlung [Munchen] 35p. 8? Bonn, P. Kautz, 1932. HOMANN, Karl, 1906- *Formverande- rungen am Schadel infolge von chronischen Er- krankungen am Kiefer. 32p. 8? Greifsw., H. Adler, 1933. HOMANN, Lotte, 1908- *Ueber die Wirkung von Leberextrakten auf die Magen- sekretion des Hundes [Munster] 15p. 8° Werne-Lippe, F. Grube, 1934. HOMANS, Amy Morris, 1848-1933. [Obituary] J. Health, Ann Arb., 1933, 4: 25.—Skarstrom, .w- Life and work of Amy Morris Homans, pioneer and leader in the field of hygiene and physical education. Res. Q. Am. Ass. Health, 1941, 12: 615-27. HOMANS, John, 1836-1903. Obituary. Q. Harvard M. Alumni Ass., 1901-4, 503-6.— Monks, G. H. Master surgeons of America. Sure. Gyn. Obst., 1927, 45: 844-8, portr. HOMANS 757 HOME HOMANS, John, 1877- A textbook of surgery;compiled from lectures and other writings of these members of the Surgical Department of the Harvard Medical School, Arthur W. Allen, David Cheever [et al.] with a special bibliographi- cal index and with illustrations by Willard C. Shepard. x, 1195p. 25cm. Springf., 111., C. C. Thomas, 1931. Also rev. ed. x p., 1231p. illust. diagrs. 1932. Also 4. ed. x, 1267p. illust. 1936. Also 5. ed. x p., 1272p. illust. diagr. 1940. ---- Circulatory diseases of the extremities. xip., 330p. illust. 16 pl. diagr. 24cm. N. Y., Macmillan co., 1939. HOMAR, Jean, 1904- *Contusions et ruptures de 1'intestin grele au cours des trau- matismes fermes de l'abdomen. 143p. 4 pl. 24^cm. Alger, S. Crescenzo, 1934. HOMARIN. Hoppe-Seyler, F. A. Ueber das Homarin, eine bisher unbekannte tierische Base. Zschr. physiol. Chem., 1933, 222: 105-15, pl. HOMAR Roig, Damian. *Contribuci6n al estudio del cultivo, aislamiento y propiedades morfo-biol6gicas del Leptothrix buccalis y de su influencia en la formaci6n del tartaro dentario [Chile] 50p. 26^cm. Santiago, Leblanc, 1938. HOMATROPINE. See also Atropine; also Ophthalmology, Thera- peutics. Plummer, F. G. Case of homatropine poisoning. Tr. Ophth. Soc.U. K., 1933, 53: 625.—W., & Haury, V. G. Homat- ropine. In Cyclop. Med. (Piersol-Bortz) Phila., 1939, 7: 303-5. HOMBACH, Karl, 1906- *Zur Behand- lung der Melancholic 32p. 8? Bonn [n. pub.] 1934. HOMBERG, Hagen, 1908- *Versuche mit Fissanpudern. 42p. 8? Lpz., A. Edelmann, 1935. HOMBERGER, August, 1873- Vor- lesungen iiber Psychopathologie des Kindesalters. xx, 852p. 8? BerL, J. Springer, 1926. HOMBORG, Karl, 1907- *Die Entwick- lung der Operationen am Hallux valgus [Bonn] 35p., iv 8? Bochum, Braun, 1933. HOMBURG, Germ. Dietlen, H. Das Landeskrankenhaus Homburg (Saar- gebiet) Deut. med. Wschr., 1935, 61: 18-20. HOMBURGER, August, 1873-1930. Mayer-Gross, W. Nekrolog. Nervenarzt, 1930, 3: 505.— Nekrolog. Zschr. Kinderforsch., 1930, 39: 109-11, portr. HOME, Sir Anthony Dickson, 1826-1914. Service memories, vii, 340p. portr. 8? Lond., E. Arnold, 1912. HOME, Everard, 1756-1832. Practical obser- vations on the treatment of strictures in the urethra, and in the oesophagus. 3. ed. vol. 1. xvi, 570p. pl. 8? Lond., G. & W. Nicol, 1805. For biography see Cat. Portr. R. Coll. Surgeons, Lond., 1930, 80. HOME, Francis, 1719-1813. Hume. E. E. The Scottish military surgeon who first described diphtheria as a clinical entity. Bull. Hist. M., 1942, 11: 48-68, 2 portr. HOME, Henry. The engineer and the pre- vention of malaria, x, 176p. front. 13 pl. 8? Lond., Chapman & Hall, 1926. HOME, Richard, 1900- *Ueber das Sacrococcygealdermoid [Leipzig] 26p. 8? [Zeulenroda, A. Oberreuter] 1928. . HOME, William Edward, 1860-1935. [Obituary] Lancet, Lond., 1935, 1: 1470. HOME. See also Family; Group; Habitation; Housing. Hole, J. The homes of the working classes, with suggestions for their improvement. 214p 8? Lond., 1866. New York State College of Agriculture. Cornell extension bulletin for homemakers. Ithaca, No. 105-329, 1925-35. Arnett, L. D. Origin and development of home and love of home. Pedag. Semin., Worcester, 1902, 9: 324-65.—Clay, H. H. The house as a home: design, construction and equipment as they affect comfort. J. R. San. Inst., 1936-37, 57: 747- 59.—Erb, F. L. Homes for our rural people. Pub. Health Nurs., 1941, 33: 293-7.—Evolution (The) of the modern home. Science Leaflet, 1940-41, 14: No. 19, 5-10.—Harrison, P. T. The house as a home: design, construction and equipment as they affect comfort. J. R. San. Inst., 1936-37, 57: 742-6.— Kenyeres, G. [Construction of homes for village-physicians in rural areas] Nepegeszsegugy, 1938, 19: 316-32.—Krage, C. [Modern physicians' homes] Ugeskr. laeger, 1934, 96: 1222- 5.—Mangot, R. Extension de la legislation concernant les habitations k bon marche et la petite propriety aux Colonies et pays de protectorat. Rapp. Congr. san. pub., Marseille, 1922, 3. Congr., 513-26.—Riemer, S. H. Family life as the basis for home planning; a sociologist looks at housing design techniques. In Housing for Health (Am. Pub. Health Ass.) Lancaster, 1941, 116-39.—Soerono [Voluntary improvement of homes in the Madja subdistrict (Madjalengka Regency) Residency of Cheribon] Meded. dienst volksgez. Ned. Indie, 1939, 28: 283-305. ---- Sanitation. Mullowney, J. J. The hygiene of the home, and responsibility for sex education. 195p. 8? Bost. [1926] Perry, J. F. Health in our homes. 112p. 12? Bost., 1887. Brinkerhoof, L. Home hygiene classes as taught in New York City High Schools. Am. J. Nurs., 1927, 27: 633-7.— Glegg, R. A. General sanitation of the home. Mat. & Child Welf., Lond., 1925, 9: 355-9—Hodgetts, C. A. The health authorities work in the home. Proc. Engl.-speaking Conf. Inf. Mortal., Lond., 1913, 1: 55-62.—Home hygiene reaches natives of Alaska. Red Cross Courier, 1939^10, 19: No. 6, 23.—Home sanitation. Pub. Health Rep., Wash., 1940, 55: 2282-4.—Ludwick, N. Improvising in the rural home. Am. J. Nurs., 1935, 35: 325-9.—Oden, R. Sanitation of the country home. Illinois M. J., 1934, 66: 551-3.—Pulkins, S. [Unsanitary condition of government homes at Omsk railroad junction] Omsky med. J., 1927, 2: 71-3.—Segard. Eau, gaz, electricity; 3 dangers du home. Arch. mid. chir. province, 1927, 17: 137-40.—Smiley, D. F. Hygiene of the home. In Pract. Libr. M. & S. (Appleton) N. Y., 1937, 12: 195-231. HOME and health; a household manual con- taining 2,000 recipes and helpful suggestions on the building and care of the home in harmony with sanitary laws; the preservation of health by clean, consistent living [&c] xi, 589p. 8? Mountain View, Calif., Pacific press pub. co., 1907. HOME (The) doctor; compiled from the writings and practical experience of over 100 famous physicians. 300p. 8? Mound City, Kans., Republic Steam print, house, 1895. HOME economics. See also Diet; Group, Economics, etc. Hess, K. P. Blankets, sheets, and towels for the home. 31p. 8? Manhattan, 1938. Journal of Home Economics. Bait., v.l8:-19: 1926-27. Lithuania. Centralinis Statistikos Biuras [Resultats de 1'enquete organised en Lithuanie durant les annees 1936-37, sur les budgets de 297 families ouvrieres, d'employes et de fonction- naires] 135p. 6 ch. 29cm. Kaunas, 1939. Andrews, B. R. The American Home Economics Associa- tion and its work. Congr. internat. aliment., 1910, 2. Congr., 2: sect. 7, 65-8.—Andross, M. Present-day cost of edible pro- tein, first class. Nutrit. Abstr., Aberdeen, 1941-42, 11: 108 (Abstr.)—Birdseye, M. What the modern homemaker needs to know. Yearb. U. S. Dep. Agr., 1939, 372-9—Cost of living of the working classes. J. R. Statist. Soc, Lond., 1941, 104: 53-8.—Davison, R. L. New possibilities in low-cost home con- struction. In Housing for Health (Am, Pub. Health Ass.) HOME ECONOMICS 758 HOMEOPATH Lancaster, 1941, 103-S—Family expenditures in selected cities, 1935-36; food. Nutrit. Abstr., Aberdeen, 1941-42, 11: 112 (Abstr.)—Jones, D. C. Three working-class family budgets; the balance of basic nei ds and resources. Ibid., 108 (Abstr.)— Kaplan, A. D. H., Williams, F. M., & Epstein, L. A. Family income and expenditure in selected Southeastern cities. 1935- 36; family expenditure. Ibid., 110 (Abstr.)------Family income and expenditure in selected urban communities of the West Ccntral-Rockv Mountain region, 1935-36; family expendi- ture Ibid., 109 (Abstr.)—Kaplan, A. D. H., Williams, F. M., & Hanson, A. C. Family income and expenditure in New Ymk Cm, 1935-36; family expenditure. Ibid., 112 (Abstr.) — Langworthy, C. F., it Spcthmann, M. T. Ui-rlier education in home economics in the United States. Congr. internat. aliment., 1910, 2. Congr., 2: Sect. 7, 113- Lorimer, F., .V Itoburk, H. Economics of the family relative to number of children. Mil- bank Mem. Fund Q., 1940, 18: III :;i'..—Liiders. M. E. Organisierte Sparsamkeit in Haus mal \\ ii isclciti. Tmscliau, 1927, 31: 977-9.—Ministry of La!" .ur ami National Service; weekly expenditure of working-ch - 1 .•• c-elmlds in the United Kingdom in 1973-38. Nutrit. Abstr., Aberdeen, 1941-42, 11: 107 (Abstr.)—Moll-Weiss. L'enseignement manager; enseigne- ment technique. In Le lait (France. Journf-e it. social.) Troyes, 1934, 19-24.—Moorehead, M. B. Outlines for course in domestic hygiene, College of Agriculture, University of Minnesota. Congr. internat. aliment., 1910, 2. Congr., 2: Sect. 7, 69.—Shepperd, J. L. Course in domestic science, College of Agriculture, University of Minnesota. Ibid., 82-6.— Williams, F. M., & Hanson, A. C. Money disbursements of wage earners and clerical workers in 5 cities in the Pacific region, 1934-36; also 11 cities in the North Atlantic region. Nutrit. Abstr., Aberdeen, 1941-42, 11:111 (Abstr.) ------& Wimsatt, G. B. Money disbursements of wage earners and clerical workers in 8 cities in the East north central region, 1934-36. Ibid., 110 (Abstr.)—Working, H. War and commodity prices. J. Am. Statist. Ass., 1940, n. ser., 35: 309-24. HOME industry. See also Industry. Skixner, M. Prohibition of industrial home work in selected industries under the National Recovery Administration. 28p. 23cm. Wash., 1938. Crist, H. Subsistence manufacturing. He. Month., 1942, 54: 132-7.—Glibert. Le bilan pathologique du travail k domicile. Mouvement hyg., Brux., 1913, 29: 377-91.—Holtz- mann. F. Heimarbeit; Kinderarbeit. In Handb. Berufskrankh. (Koelstb, F.) Jena, 1937, 2: 1105-7.—Mengeringhausen, M. Heimtechnik. Umschau, 1929, 33: 346-51.—Schmidt-Lange, W. Die Heimarbeiter an der Ostgrenze Bayerns; gewerbe- und sozialhygienische Untersuchungen. Arch. Hyg., Miinch., 1936- 37, 117: 87-111. HOMEN, Ernst Alexander, 1851-1926. Ex- perimentelle und pathologische Beitrage zur Kenntnis der infektiostoxischen, nichteitrigen Enzephalitis. 2 p. 1. 90p. 7 pl. 8? Jena, G. Fischer, 1919. For biography see Arb. Path. Inst. Helsingfors, 1927, n. F., 5: 1-4, portr. (A. Wallgren) Also Beitr. path. Anat., 1927, 77: H. 1 (L. AschofT) Also Fin. lak. sail, hand., 1927, 69: 95-107, portr. (J. Hagelstam) Also Hygiea, Stockh., 1927, 89: 73-9 (F. Henschen) HOMENAJE del Panamericanismo medico a la memoria Dr Luis Razetti, gloria de la medicina social contemporanea. 138p. portr. 8? Cara- cas, Casa de Especial., 1934. HOMEN de Mello, Oscar, 1893-1932. [Necrologia] Ann. paul. med. cir., 1933, 25: 35. HOMEOPATH. See also Homeopathy. Hall, J. B. American directory of homoeo- pathic physicians. 89p. 12? Cleveland, 1867. Bartels, V. Der homoopathische Arzt. Fortsch. Med 1936, 54: 339-42.—Blumenthal, N. L. [Homeopathy and homeopathsl Sovet. med., 1937, 44-6.—Bryant, C. P. Why I became a convert to homoeopathy from the allopathic school of practice. Homoeop. Rev., 1941-42, 57: 377-80.—Burford, G. Masters in homoeopathy; the persistence of their work through time. Brit. Homoeop. J., 1932, 22: 116-43.—Cohen, S. S. The dissimilarity between physicians andhomoeopathists; a reply to the presidential address of Dr John B. Roberts Proc. Philadelphia Co. M. Soc, 1893, 14: 352-6.—Duty (The) of organized homeopathy. J. N. Jersey Homeop. M. Soc 1941. 1: No. 3, 8-10- Earle, R. P. Why am I studying homoe- opathy? Homoeop. Rec, 1937, 52: 207-12.—Fobes, J. H. The homeopathic suiireon. J. Am. Inst. Homeop., 1935, 28: 281-3.—Freyermuth, O. G. My homoeopathic colleagues; 2 score year= in retrofi e- Komplex-Heilweise. 2. Aufl. 207p. 24Ucm Regensb., 1939. MoNATSSCHRIFT FUR ElEKTHO- KoMH.ICX- Homoopathie. Regensb., No. 1, 1933- Bruch, O. M.. & Nonntag. F. Ueber Elektro-Komplex- Homoopathie. Deut. med. Wschr., 1931, 57: 1902.—Funke. Oesundhcitspnege durch Elektro-Komplex-Homoopathie in den Sommermonaten. Mschr. Klektr. Kompl. Homoop., I93.'i, 141-6.—Garcia Lopez, A. Contestaci6n & la Clinique dr l'homfopathie complexe. Rev. homeop., Barcel., 1890, 1: 33-7.—Weiss, K. E. Ueber homoopathische Komplexmittel Hippokrates, Stuttg., 1935, 6: 451-3. ---- Dosage and potencies. Boyd, W. E. Research on the low potencies of homoeopathy (an account of some physical properties indicating activity) 38p. 8? Lond 1936. Schwebs, G. *Zum Vergleich der medizini- schen und homoopathischen Dosierung. 26n 8? Tiib., 1937. Bass. J. W. L'alimentazione nei suoi rapporti con l'infinitesi- male. Legge dei simili, 1933, 4: 275-95.—Berne, A. The high potencies considered strictly scientifically. Homoeop Rec, 1939, 54: No. 10, 35-41.—Boyd, W. E. Potency varia- tion. Brit. Homoeop. J., 1937, 27: 87-95, 3 pl.—Brown, P. What potency? Homoeop. Rec, 1937, 52: 557-62.—Burford. G. The mathematics of homoeopathy. Brit. Homoeop. J., 1927, 17: 1-21, 4 pl.—Como ficou resolvido o enigma das dinarnizacoes altissimas. Rev. Ass. paul. homeop., S. Paulo, 1939, 3: No. 36, 15-9.—Dinamizacoes altissimas. Ibid., 1939-40, 4: No. 40, 24-9.—Enyeart, H. F. Some observations of the action of high potencies. Hahneman. Month., 1936, 71: 83-9.—Gutman, W. The question of dosage. Pacific Coast J. Homoeop., 1940, 51: 402-8.—Hnatkiewicz, W. [What is homeopathy? homeopathic doses and potencies] Med. prakt., Pozndn, 1936, 10: 321-7.—Kauffmann, F. Homo- opathische Heilmittel im Lichte der Mathematik. Med. Korbl. Y urttemberg, 1927, 97: 541.—Kiitschau, K. Ueber das Homoopathieproblem. Med. Welt, 1930, 4: 1753. ----- Concerning the experimental investigation of the high potency problem. J. Am. Inst. Homeop., 1931. 24: 324-35. —---& Simon. A. Beobachtungen uber den Gehalt wieder- holt verdunnter Losungen beziehungsweise Verreibungen; ein Beitrag zur Frage homoopathischer Potenzierung. Zschr. klin. Med., 1928, 107: 162-71.—Kroener. Sobre la acci6n del infinitamnnte pequefto en la naturaleza. Rev. homeop., Barcel., 1906, 17: 310-4.—Lebermann, F. Wirkung extremer Potenz- verdiinnungen auf niedere Organismen. Med. Welt, 1928, 2: 1225.—Leeser, O. The meaning of potentizing. Brit. Homoeop. J., 1936, 26: 138-62.—Mackenzie, G. W. The higher potencies and the wide intervals between doses in the treatment of chronic diseases. Hahneman. Month., 1935. 70: 273-90. ------Is there a law of dosage? J. Am. Inst. Homeop., 1937, 30:657-74. ------ Homeopathic philosophy; large dose and small dose. Ibid., 1938, 31: 285-8.—McCrae. W. R. A study of the action of the homoeopathic remedies on the diseased human body; potency activity, especially in relation to chronic conditions. Brit. Homoeop. J., 1936, 26: 107-37. ALso J. Am. Electron. Res. Ass., 1936, 13: 232-5.—Marquez, H. G. The high-potency question from the standpoint of the exact natural sciences. J. Am. Inst. Homeop., 1937, 30: 73-81.—Martini, P. Schlusswort zu Schoolers Entgegnung auf unsere homoopathi- schen Arzneimittelprufungcn am Gesunden. Munch, med Wschr., 1939, 86: 1048.—Mitchell, G. R. Problems of potency selection. Brit. Homoeop. J., 1939, 29: 116-48.—Moore, T. K. Potency. Homoeop. Rec, 1940, 55: No. 11, 13-8.—Muller. K. W. Experimentelle Untersuchungen in vitro et vivo zur Frage der Wirksamkeit homoopathischer VerdUnnunnen und HOMEOPATHY 761 HOMEOPATHY Komplexmittel (ausgefiihrt mit Mercurius cyanatus Oligoplex) Hippokrates, Stuttg., 1938, 9: 857-64.—Munch, W. Zur Geschichte der homoopathischen Gabenlehre. Wien. med. Wschr., 1939, 89: 369-71.—Nogue Roca [J.l Las dosis infinite- simales y la neuro-aniilisis. Rev. homeop. catalana, 1883, 1: 41-9. ------ Posologfa homeop&tica. Rev. homeop., Barcel., 1890* 2: 257-63.—Oliveira Penna, C. de. Contra a homeopatia; dose.' Rev. Ass. paul. homeop., S. Paulo, 1939, 3: No. 34, 19-25. -----■ A dose homeopAtica. Gaz. clin., S. Paulo, 1940, 38: 333_8 —Pol Ma, J. A. The infinitesimal becomes finitesimal. Pacific Coast J. Homoeop., 1934, 45: 449-53.—Pulford. A. On the mystery of the infinitesimal homoeopathic dose. Homoeop. Rec, 1941—42, 57: 349-53.—Reciente triunfo de los sectarios de las dosis infinitesimales. Bandera homeop. Habana, 1856, 1: igi.—Rice, P. The potency question. Pacific Coast J. Homoeop., 1940, 51: 264-6.—Roberts, H. A. The mathemati- cal problem in comparative materia medica. Homoeop. Rec, 1932, 47: 798-808. ------ Homoeopathic potentials in diet. Ibid., 1941, 56: 3-8.—Robinson, W. W. The high attenuation; its historv and modes of preparation. Ibid., 51-72.-—Rojahn, C. A., & Wieder, H. Ueber die Grosse des Kolloidanteils in homoopathischen Verreibungen. Arch. Pharm., Berl., 1934, 272:198-221, pl.—Roy, C. Potentization, dilution and attenua- tion. Homoeop. Rec, 1939, 54: No. 8, 37.—Roy, J. La dilution hom^opathique; sa justification exp6rimentale. Bull. mid., Par., 1932, 46: 528-30.—Schlegel, O. Die Frage der Verdunnungen in der Homoopathie. Hippokrates, Stuttg., 1938, 9: 549-51.—Schmidt, R. A. The administration of high potencies. Pacific Coast J. Homoeop., 1938, 49: 148-56.— Shippen, R. Indications for the correct potency. Homoeop. Rev 1941-42, 57: 385-91.—Stearns, G. B. Phvsics of high dilutions. Homoeop. Rec, 1931, 46: 391-418.—Stevens, G. Some questions on the sequence of potencies. Ibid., 1940, 55: No. 10, 14-9. •------ Reasons for using high potencies in the practice of homeopathy. J. Am. Inst. Homeop., 1940, 33: 597.—Sutherland, A. D. Experiences with potencies. Homoeop. Rec 1937, 52: 308-17.—Terrades. Atenuaciones, dosis, repetici6n. Rev. homeop., Barcel.. 1890, 1: 138; 178; 1890, 2: 43; 73.—Tosi, V. Laripetizione delle dosi. Legge dei simili, 1930, 1: 178-89.—Underhill, E., jr. The dose and its repetition. Brit. Homoeop. J., 1936, 26: 103-6. Also Homoeop. Rec, 1936 51: 51-9. ------ Widening our range of potentized medication. Ibid., 1941, 57: 254-6.—Velasco, M. T. Las dosis infinitesimales. Rev. homeop., Barcel., 1907, 18: 34-8.— Wheeler, C. E. The unit dose. Brit. Homoeop. J., 1939, 29: 154-6.—Wurmser, L., & Loch, P. Recherches expdrimentales sur les dilutions homoeopathiques. Sitzber. Kongr. Liga homeop. internat., 1935, 10. Congr., 359-73. --- History. Bartels [H. O.] V. *Beitrage zur Geschichte der naturwissenschaftlichkritischen Richtung in der Homoopathie [Berlin] 48p. 8? Lpz., 1933. Schmideberg, M. geb. Klein. *Geschichte der homoopathischen Bewegung in Ungarn [Berlin] 89p. 8? Lpz., 1929. Tischner, R. E. Geschichte der Homoopathie. 3v. 8? Lpz., 1932-37. Vallee, M. *L'organisation actuelle de I'homeopathie en France. 281p. 8? Lyon, 1936. Allendy, R. La tradition hippocratique et l'homeopathie. Bull, med., Par., 1932, 46: 525.—Bastanier, E. Bericht uber die Lage und Entwicklung der Homoopathie in Deutschland im Jahre 1934-35. Sitzber. Kongr. Liga homeop. internat., 1935, 10. Congr., 424-8.------Die Bedeutung der Homo- opathie fur das Krankenhauswesen. Zschr. ges. Kranken- hauswes., 1936, 82.—Bellows, H. P. Fifty years ago and now; a review of homoeopathy. J. Am. Inst. Homeop., 192b, 19: 122-36.—Berghe, S. van den. L'homoeopathie en Belgique. Sitzber. Kongr. Liga homeop. internat., 1935, 10. Congr 422.— Bodman, F. H. The present-day confirmation of the homoeo- pathic approach. Brit. Homoeop. J., 1939, 29: 4-18—-Boud- ard, J. Involution of medical ideas and homoeopathy. Pacific Coast J. Homoeop., 1937, 48: 364-81.—Boyd, G. Hahnemann in the light of homeopathic research. J. Am. Inst. Homoeop., 1935, 28: 133-9.—Boyd, L. J. Some factors responsible for the recent progress in homeopathy. Ibid., 1931, 24: 1Z13-61. Brachwitz, G. P. R. Zur Geschichte der Ktost-erapotheken und der Homoopathie in Wien. Fortsch. Med., 1935, 53: 455.—Brown, P. Fifty years with homoeopathy Homoeop. Rec, 1939. 54: No. 10, 23-8.-Burrett, C. A. Homeopathy during the past quarter of a century. Hahneman. Month., 1935 70: 401-11 .—Carta abierta al Dr D. Valentin Carulla, catedriitico de terapeutica de la Facultad de medicina de Barcelona. Rev. homeop., Barcel.. 1906, 17: 619-67.— Comet. Alopatfa y homeopatia entre rn|dicos; relato ngurosa- mente historico. Ibid., 1894, 5: 30; 76; 173;; 196.—Cooper. L. H. Report on the state and progress of homeopathy in England during the past year. Sitzber. Kongr Liga homeop internat., 1935? 10. Congr., 428-33-Dewey, W A History of homoeopathy in California. Pacific Coast J. Homoeop 1939 50: 219-37.—Eckman, J. Homeopathic and eclectic medicine in Minnesota. Minnesota M., 1941 24: 474; passim.— Enstam.C.H. Rebuilding homeopathy. ,L Am. Inst. Homeop., 1940 33- 329-34. Also Pacific Coast J, Homoeop., 1940, 51. 216-27— Enyeart, H. F. Following the master, Hahnemann Hahneman. Month., 1938, 73: 633-9.—Expose (Un) de la doctrine homeopathique en 1832. Progr. mid.. Par 1931 Suppl., 33-40.—Ferreyrolles, P. La loi de similitude, son mode d application; l'homeopathie d'hier, celle d'aujourd'hui. Ibid., 797-806.—Flemming, A. The development of homeop- athy in Russia 1824-1928; a contribution to the history of homeopathy. J. Am. Inst. Homeop., 1930, 23: 649-62 — Fortier-Bernoville, M. Etat de l'homoeopathie en France, 1935. Sitzber. Kongr. Liga homeop. internat., 1935, 10. Congr., 433-48.—Gabrilovich, N. L'homoeopathie en USSR en 1934-35. Ibid., 460-2.—Gardner, F. T. Flashes of homoe- opathy m early California. Pacific Coast J. Homoeop., 1940, 51: 87-95.—Genesis (La) de la homeopatia. Rev. homeop., Barcel., 1906, 17: 191-3.—Ghose, S. C. Present status of homeopathy in India and how to safeguard its interests. Ind. M. Rec, 1934, 54: 358-63. Also Brit. Homoeop. J., 1938, 28: 110-29.—Griffith, I. The doctrine of signatures. In his Lobscows, Phila., 1939, 320.—Gutmann. Bericht iiber Oester- reich. Sitzber. Kongr. Liga homeop. internat., 1935, 10. Congr., 454-6.—Guttentag, O. E. Trends toward homeopathy; present and past. Bull. Hist. AL, 1940, 8: 1172-93.—Haehl, E. Die deutsche und die amerikanische Homoopathie, ihre Beziehungen und gegenseitige Befruchtung. Hippokrates, Stuttg., 1937, 8: 779.—Harris, A. D. The future of homoe- opathy. Homoeop. Rec, 1937, 52: 269-75.—Hnatkiewicz. Franzosischer Bericht uber Polen. Sitzber. Kongr. Liga homeop, internat., 1935, 10. Congr., 456-8.—Homoopathische (Die) Bewegung in Ungarn 1934-35. Ibid., 468-71.—Homeo- patia (La) en los Estados Unidos. Rev. homeop. catalana, 1883, 1: 18.—Hutchinson, J. Homoeopathy today; medical science and art of the centuries. Homoeop. Rec, 1941-42, 57: 473-84.—Jonas, G. L. L'homoeopathie dans la R£publique Argentine 1930-35. Sitzber. Kongr. Liga homeop. internat., 1935, 10. Congr., 418-21.—Kalinowski, M. Polen. Ibid., 458-60.—Kapferer, R. Allopathie und Homoopathie, die Heilprinzipien bei Hippokrates. Hippokrates, Stuttg., 1934, 5: 107-10.—Majumdar, J. N. Report of the progress of homoe- opathy in India during the year 1934-35. Sitzber. Kongr. Liga homeop. internat., 1935, 10. Congr., 451.—Martiny. La similitudine e l'infinitesimale attraverso la storia della medicina. Legge dei simili, 1933, 4: 307-30.—Mattoli. Re- lazione sullo stato dell'omiopatia in Italia. Sitzber. Kongr. Liga homeop. internat., 1935, 10. Congr., 452-4.—Mattson, A. S. Homoeopathy; past, present, and future. Pacific Coast J. Homoeop., 1931, 42: 386-400.—Mills, E. P. A review of 40 years of medicine. Ibid., 1936, 47: 343-51/— Neugebauer, H. Die Entwicklung der Homoopathie und ihre augenblickliche Lage. Arch. Pharm., Berl., 1933, 271: 581- 94.—Nogue Roca, J. Crfjnica; progresos de la homeopatia. Rev. homeop., Barcel., 1890, 2: 225-43. ------ Homeopatia (La) en los Estados Unidos de America. Ibid., 1892, 3: 56-8.— Ogden, W. The rise and decline of homeopathy. Minnesota M., 1934, 17: 472-7.—Pagel, J., & Sudhoff, K. One-sided therapeutic and philosophical tendencies; homeopathy; Schelling's nature philosophy. Med. Life, 1931, 38: 647-56 — Paterson, J. Has homoeopathy progressed? retrospect 1910-35. Brit. Homoeop. J., 1937, 27: 24-35.—Perez Vargas, C. Ale- mania y la homeopatia. Rev. homeop., Mix., 1939, 4: No. 3, 6-15.—Rabe, H., & Scholer, H. A Alemanha e la homeopatia. Rev. Ass. paul. homeop., S. Paulo, 1939-40, 4: No. 38, 13-23.— Rabe, R. F. Homeopathy; what of its future? Hahneman. Month., 1941, 76: 369-80.—Records, A. W. General survey of the homeopathic situation in the United States. Sitzber. Kongr. Liga homeop. internat., 1935, 10. Congr.,-417.—■ Roman, D. Hahnemann's place in medical history. Hahne- man. Month., 1936, 71: 249-56, portr.—Sandell, M. N. Report from Sweden. Sitzber. Kongr. Liga homeop. internat., 1935, 10. Congr., 464.-—Savelsberg, K. Grundsatze der Homoopathie und ihre Entwicklung in neuerer Zeit. Wien. med. Wschr., 1939, 89: 220-2.—Seidel, R. E. Pan-American report; Secretary-Treasurer, 1941; U. S. A. and Canada. J. Am. Inst. Homeop., 1942, 35: 93-6.—Selfridge, J. M. An epitome of the early history of homoeopathy in California. Pacific Coast J. Homoeop., 1935, 46: 295-302.------Medical reminiscences. Ibid., 335-43.—S, F. M. Trends in home- opathy. J. Am. Inst. Homeop., 1941, 34: 214.—Siemon, L. E. A nuestros colegas de los paises Latino-Americanos. Rev. homeop., Mix., 1939, 4: No. 2, 4.—Silva, A, N. da. Etat actuel de l'homoeopathie au Bresil. Sitzber. Kongr. Liga homeop. internat., 1935, 10. Congr., 422.—Situation de l'homoe- opathie en Suisse. Ibid., 466.—Tischner, R. The history of homepathy; I. & II. (translated by L. J. Boyd) J. Am. Inst. Homeop., 1933, 26: 203; passim.—Upham, R. A review of homeopathy in the United States of America during 1934-35. Sitzber. Kongr. Liga homeop. internat., 1935, 10. Congr., 414-7.—Valdes O-Farril, R. La homeopatia en los campo? de Cuba. Bandera homeop. Habana, 1856, 1: 408.—Vernieri, A di. Um pouco de historia. Rev. Ass. paul. homeop., S.'Paulo, 1939, 3: No. 31, 13-5.—Vinyals, A. L'homoeopathie en Espagne. Sitzber. Kongr. Liga homeop. internat., 1935, 10. Congr., 466.—Voorhoeve. J. N. Bericht iiber den Stand und die"Entwicklung der Homoopathie in Holland. Ibid., 449.__Ward, J. W. Watchman, what of the night? a retrospect; a perspective; an inventory. J. Am. Inst. Homeop., 1939, 32: 651-5—Weir, J- Making history in 1932. Brit. Homoeop. J 1932 22: 387-91.—Wheeler, C. E. One hundred years of homoeopathy. Brit. M. J., 1937, 2: Suppl., No. 1716, 245. ------ Homoeopathy; 100 years of a heresy. Med. Press & HOMEOPATHY 762 HOMEOPATHY Circ, Lond., 1937, 195: 396; 4 19.—Wheeler, C. H. Homoeo- path) ; 100 years of heresy. Pacific Coast J. Homoeop., 1938, 49: 71-91.— Woodbury, B. (". Hahnemann's second task. Homoeop. Rec, 1935, 50: 169-76. ------ Clinical homoeo- pathic therapeutics; its origin, history and future outlook. Homoeop. Rev., 1941-4, 57: 397-404.—Woods, H. C. A. short resume of the origin, development and present-day status of homeopathy. J. Am. Inst. Homeop., 1936, 29: 615-7.—Wright, J. Ancient and modern medical heresies (I) Homoepathy and ChiiMian Science. Med. J. & Rec, 1926, 123: 324-6.—Wurm, M. Bericht iiber den Stand der Homoo- pathie in der CSR. Sitzber. Kongr. Liga homeop. internat., 1935, 10. Congr., 467. ---- Hospitals and institutes. Brooklyn Homoeopathic Hospital. Annual reports. Brooklyn, v.3-26, 1875-96. Camden Homoeopathic Hospital. Annual report. Camden, N. J., v.4, 1888. Cleveland Homoeopathic Hospital. An- nual report. Clevel., 1870/1-1900/1. Helmuth, X. Y. Gowanda State Homeo- pathic Hospital. Annual report of the visitors. Utica, N. Y., 23., 1915-16. Kansas City Homoeopathic Hospital. Re- port. Kansas City, v.l, 1889-90. Middletown, X. V. State Homeopathic Hospital. Annual report. Utica, N. V., 4., 1S73- 74. New York, X. Y. Hahnemann Hospital. Annual report. X. Y., v.1-31, 1876/77-1899/ 1900. Ward's Island, N. Y. Homoeopathic Hos- pital. Annual report. X. Y., v.5-13, 1879 1887. Donner, F. Homoopatische Klinik; Bericht iiber die Tatig- keit der homoopathischen Universitatspoliklinik in Berlin. Sitzber. Kongr. Liga homeop. internat., 1935, 10. Congr., 164-8.—Eckman, J. Homeopathic and eclectic medicine in Minnesota. Minnesota M., 1941, 24: 474; passim.—Guttentag, O. E. Merger, yes; department of therapeutics, no. Hahne- man. Month., 1941, 76: 461-7.—Hahnemann (The) Hospital of San Francisco. Homoeop. Rec, 1941, 56: 145, illust.— Hospital (El) homeop&tico. Rev. homeop., Barcel., 1890, 2: 33.—Kalinowski, M. [The homeopathic hospital in Stuttgart] Med. prakt., Poznari, 1936, 9: 150-5.—King, W. H. A review of the early history of the New York Homeopathic Medical College and Flower Hospital. J. Am. Inst. Homeop., 1936,29: 331-7.—Klopp, H. I. Twenty-sixth annual report of the Allentown State Hospital, Homeopathic State Hospital. Hahneman. Month., 1938, 73: 803-37. ------ Twenty- seventh annual report of the Allentown State Hospital (Homeo- pathic State Hospital) 1939. Ibid., 1939, 74: 896-923. ------ Twenty-eighth annual report of the Allentown State Hospital, Homeopathic State Hospital. Ibid., 1940, 75: 795; 914.— Lang, W. Minutes of the meeting of the Board of Control of the A. I. H., held at Brown Hotel, Louisville, Ky. J. Am. Inst. Homeop., 1941, 34: 573.—Morgan, E. M. History of Homoeopathy and Homoeopathic Hospital in Montreal. Ibid. 1930, 23: 87-9.—New (The) Hahnemann hospital, San Fran- cisco. Pacific Coast J. Homoeop., 1939, 50: 127; 1940, 51: Ninety-seventh annual convention of the American Institute of Homeopathy will be held at the Cbamberlin Hotel, Old Point Comfort, Va., June 15-20, 1941. J. Am. Inst. Homeop.. 1941, »4: 218. ---- Legal status and recognition. Montemayor, P. A los honorables repre- sentantes del pueblo venezolano en su reuni6n de 1940. 17p. 23cm. Caracas, 1940. Report of the speeches on irregular practice, delivered at the 19th anniversary meeting of the Provincial Medical and Surgical Association, held at Brighton, August 13 & 14 1851. 32p. C. 8? Lond., 1851. Coermann, W. Homoopathie und andere nicht schulge- masse Behandlungsverfahren in der Rechtsprechung. Hippo- krates, Stuttg., 1938, 9: 220-5.—Condenacao da homeopatia na Argentina. Rev. Ass. paul. homeop., S. Paulo, 1939-40 4: No. 37, 9.— Homoeopathie (L') k l'Academie de medecine' Gaz. san., Par., 1835, 4: 88-94.—Homoeopathie (L') jugee par la Society de medecine de Marseille. J. mid. Toulouse, 1855, 2. ser., 5: 222-4.—[Legislation on dispensing of homeopathic medicines] Pharm. tid., Kbh., 1861-62, 1: 123.—L, H. A proposito da proibicao de medicamentos homeop it icos na Argentina. Rev. Ass. paul. homeoo., S. Paulo, 1939-40 4- No. 37, 21-4.—Morello, P. Introduzione alio studio della dottrina omeopatica; necessita di liberate la dottrina omeo- patica dall'imputazione d'impostura con cbe piaoe a taluni medici di raccomandarla all'attenzione del pubblico. Gazz. toscana sc. med. fis., 1850, 8: 345-59. -----r Introduzione alio studio della dottrina omeopatica; del diritto che ha il pubblico, a sapere se la omeopatia sia un'impostura o no, e del dovere che hanno i medici di soddisfare ad un tal diritto onestamente e ragionevolmento. Ibid., 361-72.—Opinion de M. le 8<5nateur Dumas sur l'homoeopathie, expos<5e devant le S£nat A l'occasion de 2 petitions. J. chim. m° Med' Times. L°nd., 1936, 64: 116- 19.-Licks, F. C. & Erlenbach, H. A. Drug prov ng at the ^34n4fi.ai7. o^1 £0lJege'^ Pacific CoagstP J rfomeop.! rhf nr?W^5-93;,-Ma£kenzie, G. W. The difference between methodnf.andt ^e homeopathic diagnostic viewpoints and WfsT ™ ,t.re.at,5len,tf ,.J' ,Am- Inst- Homeop., 1940, 33: nrnf,,;7, ar^ni' Pa Ue*7 dl? homoopathische Arzneimittel- prufung am Gesunden. Munch, med. Wschr., 1939 86- 721- loTo. °^r.e'J" ,o ^TSS0"^10 technique- Homoeop.' Rec, IrltJ N£ ]2'19-26-Munch, W. Der Arzneimittel^ yersuch am Gesunden und seine Bedeutung fiir die Homoo- therapie Wien. med. Wschr., 1939. 89: 58-61.-Nogu" Roca, J. Carta, abierta al Sr Dr D. Jose Ricart. Rev. homeop Barcel., 1892, 3: 65-80.-Persson, W. M. Scientific investi- gation work. J. Am. Inst. Homeop., 1933, 26: 527-9 —Ricart J. Contestaci6n al Sr Dr D. Jose Nogui. Rev. homeop ' Barcel 1892, 3: 129 ----- Deficiencias del lenglaje homeopdtico. Ibid., 6-17.—Roberts, H. A. The study of remedies by comparison. Homoeop. Rec, 1937, 52: 291-307 — Schmidt, P. The homoeopathic consultation: the art of interro- gation. Ibid., 1933, 48: 157-79.—Schmidt, R. A. Clinical verifications. Pacific Coast J. Homoeop., 1938, 49: 231-4__ Schoeler, H. The significance of objective symptomatology 'or the testing of homoeopathic remedies. Brit. Homoeop. J., 1938, 28: 40-52.------Die homoopathische Arzneimittel- prufung. Hippokrates, Stuttg., 1938, 9: 1001-8. ------ Ueber die homoopathische Arzneimittelpriifung am Gesunden Miinch. med. Wschr., 1939, 86: 1045-8.—Unger, H. Ueber den Sinn der homoopathischen Anamnestik. Hippokrates, Stuttg 1941 12: 264-9—Young, W. W. The homoeopathic versus the diagnostic method. Pacific Coast J. Homoeop., 1933, 44: 403-8.------Hering test; history, technic, theory, and report of a series of 458 cases. J. Am. Inst. Homeop., 1936, 29:337-44. ------ Animal experimentation, an aid to home- opathy. Ibid., 1939, 32: 678-81. ---- Periodicals. Bandera (La) de la homeopatia en la habana. Habana, vl, 1857. British Homoeopathic Journal. Lond', v.14, 1924- Hahnemannian Monthly. Phila., v.9, 1873- Hippokrates. Wochenschrift neue deutsche Heilkunde. Stuttg., v.l, 1928- Homoeopathic Recorder. Derby, Conn., v.l, 1886- Journal of the American Institute of Homeopathy. Camden, N. J., v.l, 1909- Legge (La) dei simili. Arezzo, v.l, 1930. Pacific Coast Journal of Homoeopathy. Berkeley, Calif., v.l, 1893- Quarterly Homoeopathic Journal. Bost., v.l, 1849. Revista homeopXtica. Barcel., v. 1-4, 1890- 93. Revista homeopXtica catalana. Barcel., v.l, No. 1, 1882. Revista homeopXtica. Mex., v.3, 1938- Revista de homeopatia. S. Paulo, v.5, Nos. 54-55, 1941- Zapatero, M. _ Prospecto de la Bandera de la Homeopatia en la Habana; periodico semanal y especial de la doctrina de Hahnemann. Bandera homeop. Habana, 1856, 1: p. i-iv. --- Pharmacology. Allen, T. F. General symptom register of the homoeopathic materia medica. 1321p. 8? N. Y., 1880. American homoeopathic Home Remedies. 70p. 16? Phila., 1890. American Institute of Homoeopathy. Com- mittee on Pharmacopceia. The homoeopathic pharmacopoeia of the United States. 4. ed. 680p. 8? Bost,, 1936. Also 5. ed. 680p. 1938. Arndt, H. R. First lessons in the sympto- matology of leading homoeopathic remedies. 271p. 16? Phila., 1904. Baltimore. Medical Investigation Club. Pathogenetic materia medica, based upon Drs Hughes' and Dake's Cyclopedia of drug patho- genesy. 347p. 8? Phila., 1895. HOMEOPATHY 764 HOMEOPATHY Boxxinohausex, C. vox. Systematic, alpha- betic repertory of homoeopathic remedies. 2. ed. 269p. 8? Phila., 1900. Boericke, W. Tucket manual of homoeo- pathic materia medica. 1049p. 18? X. Y. 1906. Also 9. ed. 12? 1927. Bruckmek, L. *Homopathische Arzneimittel- priifung mit Bryonia und Secale cornutum. ."dip. 8? Bonn, 1938. Dewev, W. A. Essentials of homoeopathic materia medica and homoeopathic pharmacv. 3. ed. 376p. 8° Phila., 1899. Also 4. ed. 372p. 1908. Farrington, E. A. A clinical materia medica; being a course of lectures delivered at the Hahne- mann Medical College of Philadelphia. 752p. 8? Phila., 1887. Hexnic. M. E. Homoopathische Pharma- kopoe und Arzneimittellehre. 2. Aufl. 556p. 8? Berl., 1935. HOMOOPATHISCHES ARZXEIBUCH. 2. Aufl. 441p. 8? Lpz., 1934. Hughes, R., & Doxxer, F. Einfiihrung in die homoopathische Arzneimittellehre. 228p. 8? Radebeul [1932] Humphreys, I'. Mentor do Dr Humphreys; or, Conselheiro da familia, para uso da medicina (■specifica. 463p. 12? X. V., [1927] Kent, J. T. Repertory of homoeopathic materia medica. 4. ed. 1423p. 8? Chic, 1935. Leeser, O. Lehrbuch der Homoopathie. Spezieller Teil: Arzneimittellehre; A: Die minerali- schen Arzneimittel. 734p. 8? Stutlg., 1933. Also translation from the Ccrman. 9S7p. 8? Phila., 1935. Madais & Co. Abgekiirzte homoopathische Pharmakopoe. 128p. X? Radebeul [1931] Malcolm, J. G. Supplement to Malcolm and Moss' Regional and comparative materia medica. 5000. ed. 76p. 8? Hutchinson, Kans., 1899. Mullen, B. Neuer arztlicher Rezeptschatz; ein arztliches Nachschlagebuch. 348p. 8? Munch. [1933] Nash, E. B. Regional leaders. 282p. 16? Phila., 1901. Pulford, A., & Pclford, D. T. Key to the homoeopathic materia medica. 136p. 16? [Toledo, (")., 1936] Rojah.n, C. A., & Hellruxg, A. Ueber die Identifizierung der in der Homoopathie ge- brauchten Trockendrogen mit Hilfe chemischer Reaktionen und der Lumineszenz-Kapillarana- lyse. 97p. 22}*cm. Halle, 1937. Schmidt. E. Lehrbuch der homoopathischen Arzneimittellehre. 2. Aufl. 342p. 8? Dresd. [1930] Schi'i.zk, K. Die Herstellung und Prufung homoopathischer Arzneimittel. 92p. X? Dresd., 1936. Shedd. V. \Y. The clinic repertory; including a repertory of time modalities by Dr Ide. 240p. 8? Phila.', 1908. Stauffer, K. Symptomen-Verzeichnis nebst vergleichenden Zusatzen zur homoopathischen Arzneimittellehre.- 574p. 8? Regensb., 1929. Van Denburg, M. W. Homoeopathic materia medica on a new and original plan. 34lp. 8° Fort Edward, X. Y., 1895. Vanxier. L., it Poirier, J. Precis de matiere medicale liomoeopathique. 2. ed. 589p. 19cm. Par.. 1938. Winans. ^Y. \V. Sophomore and junior notes from lectures on materia medica delivered in Hahnemann Medical College, Philadelphia, l'n. session of 1896 97. 190p. 8? Rochester, 1S97. Zimmer, H. Signaturen in der Volksmedizin. 63p. 22cm. Radebeul [1939] Accion (Dc la) de los medicamentos homeoi > a1 icos. Bandera homeop. Habana, 1856, 1: 357; 374.- Analisi delle (inline per uso omeopatieo. Gior. farm., Trieste, !!i(H, fi: 257-68. - Assmann, E. Homoeopathic pharmacy. I'acilir Coast .1. Homoeop., 1935, 16: 37'.). —Bartels. V. Kunklioiielle ZiiBam- menhange als Ergehnis der Ai znoimittelprufungcu, erliiuterl, an einer Rcihe gebrauchlidher homoopathischer Polvchreste. Fortsch. Med., 1937, 55: 97; 117.—Bastanier. Hahnemannii Kaustikum. Deut. med. Wschr., 1927, 53: 2123 [Erwiderung von Joachimoglu] 2123.—Baudry, R. E. Hahnemann on Korsakow? da preparacao dos remedios homeopaticos. Rev. Ass. paul. homeop., S. Paulo, 1939, 3: No. 35, 7-11.—Heeler, M. The Bach remedies. J. Am. Inst. Homeop., 1940, 33: l.HS 90.— Bergmann. Wetter und homoopathische Heilmittel. Fortsch. Med., 1936, 54: 81.—-Bernard, H. Homeopatia para alopatas; aigu mas pequenas experiencias homeopaticas para uso dos medicos alopatas. Rev. Ass. paul. homeop., S. Paulo, 1939, 3: No. 34, 15-8.—Bern6, T. L'absorption et l'homoeopathie. Sitzber. Kongr. Liga homeop. internat., 1935, 10. Congr., 355-8.—Beutner, R. Homeopathy in the light of experimental pharmacology and the theory of drug actions. J. Am. Inst. Homeop., 1937, 30: 131-4.—Blotin. Os doze remedios dos tecidos. Rev. homeop., S. Paulo, 1941, 5: 12-7.—Bodman, F. H. Levels of drug action. Brit. Homoeop. J., 1936, 36: 19-4 1.—Boericke, G. W. Drug proving. J. Am. Inst. Homeop.. 1940,33:577-80.------Certain indications and speculation* concerning homeopathic drugs. Hahneman. Month., 1911, 76: 107-15.—Bryant, C. P. The evidence of the invisible; force* emanating from homoeopathic remedies and their relation to similar animal and vegetable energy. Homoeop. Rec, 1935, 50: 207-16.—Carmichael, T. H. An accurate system of pharmaceutics indispensable to the intelligent use of drugs. .T. Am. Inst. Homeop., 1910, 3: 221-6.—Castueil, O. Comment faut-il comprendre le remade homoeopathique? In his Santd [&c.) Par., 1938, 35-7.------L'action rationnelle des remedes homoeopathiques. In his Sant6 [&c] Par., 1938, 41-3.— Cuthbert, E. P. Some useful homeopathic remedies we seldom use. J. Am. Inst. Homeop., 1934, 27: 211. ------ Some useful remedies we sometimes forget. Ibid., 1940, 33: 543.— De la Rosa, R. L. Five applications of 3 Schiissler remedies. Ibid.. 310-2.—[Dispensation of homeopathic medicines] Phann. tid., Kbh., 1861-62, 1: 65-8.—[Dispensation of homeo- pathic remedies from pharmacies] Ny pharm. tid., Kbh., 1879, II : 81-4.—Ehrismann, O., & Joachimoglu, G. Pharma- colojria phantustica. Deut. med. Wsehr., 1926, 52: 1383.— Farrington, H. The study of materia medica. Homoeop. Ree., 1941, 56: 243-51.—Fortier-Bernoville, M. Homoeo- pathic study of constitutions, temperaments and sequence of remedies. Pacific Coast J. Homoeop., 1938, 49: 14-38. Gagliardi, G. What shall be our attitude toward Schiissler'* tissue remedies? J. Am. Inst. Homeop., 1940, 33: 179—81. Gobar, I. C. Complementary remedies. Pacific Coast J. Homoeop., 1935, 46: 306-8. ------ Drugs used homeopathi- r:ilh as prophylactic measures. J. Am. Inst. Homeop., 1939, 32: 683.—Guernsey, H. N. Csnaeteristiea de algunos medim- menlos. Rev. homeop., Barcel., IS'C, 3: 311-5.—Haehl, K. Homoopathische Polychreste und Kou.-t itutionsmittel. Hippo- krates, Stuttg., 1937, 8: 617; pa -im. Hanna, P. G. Useful hint* on homeopathic treatment. .1. Am. Inst. Homeop., 1941, 34: 161.—Haubold, R. Homoopathische Konstitutionsmittcl. Hippokrates, Stuttg., 1937, 8: 1053-8.—Hayes, R. E. 8. Repertories, Boger's especially. Homoeop. Rec, 1939, 54: 12-23.—-Hidalgo, G. Comparaciones de los medicamentos homeopaticos y sus modalidades psiquismo. Rev. homeop., Mix., 1940, 5: No. 2, 40-3— Hinsdale, A. E. Drug pathology; principles of drug action. J. Am. Inst. Homeop., 1929, 22: 683-720, 26 pl.—Honn, W. M. Materia medica, what is it? Ibid., 1935, 28: 682.—Hubbard, E. W. Garden remedies. Homoeop. Rec, 1941, 56: 88.—Hurd, L. B. Homoeopathic remedies according to drug provings. Pacific Coast J. Homeop., 1934, 45: 529-34.—Ipsilon. Eruditos A la violeta. Rev. homeop., Barcel., 1892, 3: 50-2.—Joachimoglu, G. Ueber Hahnemanns Kaustikum. Deut. med. Wschr., 1927, 53: 1823.—Kotschau. Homoeopathy in relation to modem pharmacology. Brit. Homoeop. J., 1934, 24: 73-89.—Launing. La alternancia de los medicamentos. Rev. homeop., Barcel., 1892. 3: 29-39.—Leeser. O. Homoeopathy and its pharma- ceutical aspects. Pharm. J., Lond., 1938, 87: 495; 523. ----- The pharmaceutics of homoeopathy. Hahneman. Month., 1941, 76: 244-53.—Lins. About hormonic action from homoeo pathio remedies. Pacific Coast J. Homoeop., 1939, 50: 261-8.- Linss. Ueber hormonartige Wirkung homoopathisilier Ar? neien. Hippokrates, Stuttg., 1939, 10: 413-7- McCrae. Drugs and their electrophysical groups. Sitzber. Kongr. Liga homeop. internat., 1935, 10. Congr., 3x(i-90.—Martini, P. Homoopathische Arzneimittel-NachpriifunKeii. Arch. exp. Path., Lpz., 1938-39, 191: 141; 1939, 192: 131.----- Briickmer, L. [et al.] Homoopathische Arzneimittel; Nach- prufungen. Ibid., 141-71.—Matz, A. H. Di<-homoopathischen Hauptmittel und deren wichtigste Indikationen. Zschr. arztl. Fortbild., 1926, 23: 293-5.—Mayer, S. K. The impor- tance of modem pharmacology to the homoeopath. Brit. Homoeop. J., 1933, 23: 233-58.—Morrow, H. C, & Quacken- HOMEOPATHY 765 HOMEOPATHY bush, A. Some acts of the materia medica. Homoeop. Rec, 1940, 55: No. 10, 24-32.—Moyer, I. L. Some leads. Hahne- man. Month., 1940, 75: 486.—Nellans, B. H. A plea for con- tinued study and intensive research in materia medica and therapeutics. J. Am. Inst. Homeop., 1939, 32: 483.—Neuge- bauer, H. Zur Frage der Haltbarkeit homoopathischer Urtinkturen. Sitzber. Kongr. Liga homeop. internat., 1935, 10 Congr., 331-9.—Otto, H. Das homoopathische Taschen- bu'ch von Stauffer. Deut. Apoth. Ztg, 1939, 54: 1176.— Palme, H. [Advertisement of special homeopathic medicinesj Sven. farm, tskr., 1936, 40: 9-14.—Peyer, W. Bemerkungen zum pharmakognostischen Teil des homoopathischen Arz- neibuches. Sitzber. Kongr. Liga homeop. internat., 1935, 10. Congr., 347-54.—Pope. Examen de los principals puntos de semejanza entre la acci6n fisiol6gica y usos terapGuticos de Aconitum, Belladona, Opium, Hyosciamus, Stramonium, Gelseminum, Conium, Cannabis ind. y sat., Agaricus y glonoin. Rev. homeop., Barcel., 1892, 3: 237-45.—Pulford, A. What makes a therapeutic agent homoeopathic? Homoeop. Rec, 1937, 52: §50-2.—Redfield, R. L. Factors influencing the action of homoeopathic remedies. Pacific Coast J. Homoeop., 1936, 47: 294-8.—Renard, L. Concerning Schussler's twelve tissue remedies. J. Am. Inst. Homeop., 1940, 33: 365.— Roberts, H. A. Our remedies: why they act. Homoeop. Rec, 1936, 51: 3-11.—Ross, T. D. Spotting the remedy. Ibid., 1934, 49: 159-64.—Sailer, K. Ueber Beziehungen zwischen mineralischen und pfianzlichen ArzneistofTen in der homoo- pathischen Anwendung. Fortsch. Med., 1936, 54: 273-8 — Schilling. Versuche zum Nachweis der physikalischen Krafte der homoopathischen Arzneiform. Sitzber. Kongr. Liga homeop. internat., 1935, 10. Congr., 374-85.—Schilz, H. The action and use of the inorganic medicinal substances. J. Am. Inst. Homeop., 1933, 26: 500-6.—Schlegel, O. Von der kuriosen Welt der homoopathischen Arznei. Hippokrates, Stuttg., 1939, 10: 932-8.—Schulz, H. The action and use of the inorganic medicinal substances. J. Am. Inst. Homeop., 1933, 26: 1; 92; 169; 728; 864.—Schuize, K. Ueber alte und neue Priifungsmethoden homoopathischer Arzneimittel. Apoth. Ztg, 1926, 41: 1269. ------& Will, H. Ueber alte und neue Priifungsmethoden homoopathischer Arzneimittel. Ibid., 830.—Simonson, J. T. The antigenic action of the homeo- pathic remedy. J. Am. Inst. Homeop., 1938, 31: 717-21.— Sloan, M. W. Tissue remedies. Hahneman. Month., 1939, 74 ■ 36-42.—Stauffer, C. Um capitulo de materia medica. Rev. Ass. paul. homeop., S. Paulo, 1939, 3: No. 33, 17-21 — Stearns, G. B. Classification of remedies. Homcep. Rec, 1931, 46: 157-64.—Sylwestrowicz, H. The development of the materia medica. Hahneman. Month., 1927, 62: 248-55.— Underhill, E., jr. Observing the action of the indicated remedy. Homoeop. Rec, 1936, 51: 339-46. ----— Aggravation after eating Ibid., 1941, 57: 152.—Von Boenninghausen, C. Essay on the relationship of remedies. Ibid., 1924, 39: 364-70 — Ward, J. W. Old and forgotten remedies. Pacific Coast J. Homoeop., 1937, 48: 421-31.—Wyne, P. S. Drug groupings by means of the emanometer. Ibid., 1935, 46: 279-90.— Zimmer, A. Ueber Hahnemanns Kaustikum. Miinch. med. Wschr 1927, 74: 2137-40.—Ziprin, J. Drug room statistics. J. Am. Inst. Homeop., 1934, 27: 435 --- Principles and theories. Uercher, L. L'homoeopathie sans mystere. 117p. 25cm.' Par., 1937. Bier, A. Homoopathie und harmonische Ordnung der Heilkunde. 279p. 23cm. Miinch., 1939. . . , Boericke, G. A compend of the principles of homoeopathy for students in medicine. 178p. 8? Phila., 1929. Boericke, W. Compend of the principles of homoeopathy as taught by Hahnemann, and verified by a century of clinical application. 160p. 8? S. Franc, 1896. Boyd L. J. A study of the simile in medicine. 421p. 8? Phila., 1936. Cailleux, R. *Essai critique sur la doctrine homceopathique. lOlp. 8? Par., 1933. Lancelot, R. *La loi de similitude. 65p. 8? Par., 1930. , . . . , McGavack, T. H. The homoeopathic principle in therapeutics. 204p. 8? Phila., 1932. Ntjnes, A. J. jr. *A lei dos contrarios e a lei dos similhantes. 29p. 12? Lisb., 1874. Planer, R. Der Kampf um die Homoopathie, pro et contra. 353p. 8? Lpz., 1926. Schier, J. Biologische Erfahrungsheillehre; mit ausfuhrlicher Klarstellung der homoopathi- schen Grundbegriffe und Beriicksichtigung an- derer biologischer Heilverfahren. 380p. 8. Stuttg., 1936. Schulz, H. Similia similibus curantur; eine Studie. 2. Aufl. 44p. 8? Miinch., 1921. Selbonne, M. *Le principe de similitude en therapeutique ou Similia similibus curantur devient Contraria contrariis curantur. 59p. 8° Par., 1935. Vannier, L. La doctrine de l'homceopathic francaise. 327p. 12? Par., 1931. Aurand, S. H. Pros and cons of homoeopathic mysteries Pacific Coast J. Homoeop., 1933, 44: 188-96.—Bartlett, C. The 1 aw of similars and its corollaries in the light of modern medicine. J. Am. Inst. Homeop., 1927, 20: 849-63.—Bastanier. Ist die Homoopathie Wissenschaft? Sitzber. Kongr. Liga homeop internat., 1935, 10. Congr., 100-11.—Bellokossy, F. K. The simile and simillimum compared. Homoeop. Rec, 1939, 54: No. 3, 23-33.—Berne, A. Les bases physiques de l'hom^opathie. Arch. Inst, prophyl., Par., 1938, 10: 151-9.—Beyer, W. Unter- suchungen iiber die Grundlagen der Homoopathie. Miinch. med. Wschr., 1932, 79: 1285.—Bodman, F. H. The present- day confirmation of the homoeopathic approach. Med. Press & Circ, Lond., 1939, 202: 160; 181.—Boericke, G. A considera- tion of the Organon and chronic diseases. J. Am. Inst. Homeop., 1926, 19: 1043-50. Also Hahneman. Month., 1930, 65: 257- 64.—Borland, D. M. Reflections on homoeopathic theory and practice. Brit. Homoeop. J., 1936, 26: 267-92.—Boyd, L. J. Kotschau's scientific basis of homeopathy; a simplified version. J. Am. Inst. Homeop., 1930, 23: 1156-62.—Boyd, W. E. Electro-medical research and homoeopathy. Brit. Homoeop. J., 1930, 20: 299-330, 4 pl.—Breyer, H. Die Schichten der Aehnlichkeit. Hippokrates, Stuttg., 1936, 7: 640; 688; 712.— Burford, G. Homoeopathy as an exact science; some results of the application of the statistical test. Brit. Homoeop. J., 1930, 20: 331-9. Also J. Am. Inst. Homeop., 1931, 24: 148-53.— Buschke, A., & Curth, W. Lichen ruber und Lichen-ruber- rt ige Sa lvarsan- und Arsenexantheme als ein Beispiel fiir den Satz der Homoopathie: Similia similibus. Miinch. med. Wschr., 1928, 75: 1794.—Curi, K. Homeopatia a medicina universal. Rev. Ass. paul. homeop., S. Paulo, 1939, 3: No. 36, 20-2.—Devrient, W. Hat die Homoopathie eine wissenschaft- liche Grundlage? Fortsch. Med., 1934, 52: 957-60.—Donner, F. Der homoopathische Gedanke in der Medizin. Hippokrates, Stuttg., 1937, 8: 782.—Ellinger, P. Bringen die Forschungen der exakten Naturwissenschaften und der Biologie Beweise fur die Richtigkeit homoopathischen Denkens und Handelns? Deut. Arch. klin. Med., 1927, 157: 76-97.—Escallier. Hallaz- gos homeopaticos en mi escursi6n al terreno de la prensa alopd- tica. Bandera homeop. Habana, 1856, 1: 940; 948.—Esplicacion del sistema medico de Hahnemann. Ibid., 23; 38.—Farrington, H. Homeopathic philosophy; the chronic miasms and modern medicine. J. Am. Inst. Homeop., 1939, 32: 280-2. ------ Homeopathic philosophy; symptomatic vs pathologic prescrib- ing. Ibid., 1940, 33: 360; passim.—Feyfer, F. M. G. de [Philo- sophical back-ground of homoeopathy] Ned. tschr. geneesk., 1926, 70: 1400-10.—Fortier-Bernoville, M. The value and limits of application of the simile principle in biology and therapeutics. Pacific Coast J. Homoeop., 1939, 50: 190-204.— Galhardo. A homeopatia se preocupa com o doente. Rev. Ass. paul. homeop., S. Paulo, 1938-39, 2: No. 29, 13-8.—Gescher, J. Begriffsbestimmung in der Homoopathie. Med. Welt, 1935, 9: 1089-91. ----■— Herkunft und Auswirkung des homoo- pathischen Gedankens. Wien. med. Wschr., 1938, 88: 1278- 83 —Ghose, S. C. Homoeopathv; its truth and scientific basis. Ind. M. Rec, 1936, 56: 11; 43.—Goldsbrough, G. F. Remarks on the present position and prospect of propagation of homoeopathy as a principle in medicine. Brit. Homoeop. J., 1931, 21: 173-82.—Green, J. M. Homeopathy; philosophy; practice; a group of talks to laymen. J. Am. Inst. Homeop., 1941, 34: 534; passim. ------ More about the nosodes. Homoeop. Rec, 1941-42, 57: 340-2.—Grimmer, A. H. Occult causes and material effects. Ibid., 1934, 49: 1-6. —----- Logic and philosophy. Ibid., 1940, 55: No. 6, 3-8.—Guild, W. A. Some homeopathic standards and concepts. J. Am. Inst. Homeop., 1934, 27: 520-3.—Gutmann, W. Homoeopathic thinking. Brit. Homoeop. J., 1939, 29: 361-9. Also Homoeop. Rec, 1941, 56: 267-77.—Hahnemann, S. De la doctrina homeop&tica. Di&r. gen. cienc. mid., Barcel., 1827, 4: 57; 113 —Hartwich, F. Ueber die Grundlagen der Homoopathie. Zschr. arztl. Fortbild., 1936, 33: 7-10.—Heppe, R. Ist die Homoopathie das Resultat induktiver Forschung oder phanta- stischer Spekulation? Aertzl. Rdsch., 1928, 38: 277-83 — Hildebrandt. Grundlagen der Homoopathie. Miineh. med. Wschr., 1926, 73: 1175.—Hoff, A. Naturheilkunde und Homoopathie; Widerspruch oder Erganzung? Hippokrates, Stuttg 1937, 8: 1069-74.—Issekutz, B. [Medical sicence and homeopathy] Orvoskepzes, 1935, 25: 753-66.—Kisskalt, K., & Mahnkopf, R. Untersuchungen iiber die Grundlagen der Homoopathie. Miinch. med. Wschr., 1932, 79: 986-8.— Kotschau K. The scientific foundation of homeopathy. J. Am. Inst. Homeop., 1930, 23: 205-95. ------ The simile and contrarium as a problem of biologic medicine. Ibid., 1931, 24: 651-61 —Kroener, E. De las relaciones entre la bactenologia y la homeopatia. Rev. homeop., Barcel., 1890, 2: 105-16 — Laeen J. B. The law of similars in present day medicine. Pacific Coast J. Homoeop., 1928, 39: 6-10.-Le Tellier. Definition exacte de l'homeopathie. J. med. Fans, 196b, 5b: 565-9.—Lewis, M. C. Is homoeopathic philosophy practical? HOMEOPATHY 766 HOMEOPATHY Homoeop. Rec, 1932, 47: 794-7.—McGavack, T. H. The pathologic physiology embodied in homoeopathy. Pacific Coast J. Homoeop., 1932, 43: 460.—Mackenzie, G. W. Are sections 246 and 248, Organon of medicine, contradictory? J. Am. Inst. Homeop., 1938, 31: 622-4. ------ Hahnemann discovered the law of similars but confessed his inability to explain how it takes place. Ibid., 747. ------ Homeopathy in the light of present-day knowledge; a talk to the laity on homeopathic philosophy. Ibid., 1939, 32: 25-9.—Maraiion, G. La homeopatia y la medicina moderna. Dia mid., B. Air., 1933-34, 6: 449.—Martiny. A prop6sito de ciertos sintomas de las patogenesias hahnemanianas. Rev. homeop., Barcel., 1892, 3: 58-60. ------ La ley de los semejantes. Ibid., 315-20. ------Les frontidres de l'homoeopathie. Progr. mid., Par., 1931, 806-19.—Martiny, M. L'homeopathie: ses limites et ses possibility. Bull, med.. Par., 1934, 48: 601-4.—Mattoli, D. L'omiopatia e la sua legge dimostrata clinicamente in circa un secolo di esperienza di pura dottrina Hahnemanniana. Legge dei simili, 1932, 3: 253-61. ------ La totality dei sintomi e non il sintomo; l'Organon di Hahnemann ed il vero medico omiopatico. Sitzber. Kongr. Liga homeop. internat., 1935, 10. Congr., 158-63.—Mendoza, A. Escursi6n homeop&tica; la homeopatia en juicio ante la ideologla y prdctica clfnicas. Botica, Barcel., 1852-53, 1: 293.—Moore, T. K. My impres- sions of homoeopathy. Homoeop. Rec, 1935, 50: 71-5.— Morhardt, P. E. Le renouveau de l'homeopathie devant la critique scientifique. Presse mid., 1930, 38: 524-6.—Miinch, W. Die Grundlagen der Homoopathie. Wien. med. Wschr., 1938, 88: 1277.—Nogug Roca, J. Los limites de la ley homeo- piitica. Rev" homeop. catalana, 1883, 1: 162-9.—Ocaranza, F. La homeopatia a la luz de la biologia. Rev. med., Puebla, 1934, 6: No. 43, 14-20.—Paterson, J. A modern conception of homoeopathy. Brit. Homoeop. J., 1934, 24: 60-72.—Perez, H. G. Catechism of the homoeopathic doctrine. Homoeop. Rec, 1929, 44: 367-85.—Perin, L. Qu'est-ce que l'homoeopathie? J. mid. chir., Par., 1926, 97: 891-4.—Persson, W. M. The principle of catalysis in biochemistry and homoeopathy. J. Am. Inst. Homeop., 1930, 23: 1055-90.—Picard. Notions gim.—Roberts, H. A. Applied homeopathic philosophy. Ilalnunian. Month., 1936, 71:532-8. Also Homoeop. Rec, 1936. 51 : 79-86. ------ Modern medication and the homoeo- patliH' principles. Ibid., 1941-42, 57: 485-92.—Sabalitschka, T. ( homische und biologische Versuche und Betrachtungen zur Homoopathie. Sitzber. Kongr. Liga homeop. internat., 1935, 10. Congr., 266-86.—Schlegel, O. Homoopathie und Wissenschaft. Wien. med. Wschr., 1938, 88: 1284-7.— Schoeler, H. Grundsatzliches zum Verstiindnis der Homoo- pathie. Hippokrates, Stuttg., 1937, 8: 753-60.—Schulz, H. Similia similibus curantur. Homoeop. Rec, 1926, 41: 1; 49 Also Brit. Homoeop. J., 1935, 25: 378; 1936, 36: 49. Also J. Am. Inst. Homeop., 1930, 23: 1163-89.—Schwartz, G. C. Pome homeopathic philosophy. Hahneman. Month., 1941, 76: 770-4.—Sedillot, J. Une synthese de l'homoeopathie et de Pallopathie est-elle legitime? est-elle souhaitable? Rev. gin. clin. ther., 1937, 51: Suppl.. 1895-907.—Sieffert. G. La loi de similitude et Taction m^dicamenteuse interpr<5t6es d'aprfis les lois de Pfliiger et de Ritter-Valli. Art mid., Par., 1903, 97- 321-42.—Stearns, G. B., & Evia, E. D. The physical basis of homoeopathy. J. Am. Inst. Homeop., 1942, 35: 67; passim.— Stiegele, A. Die Pathologie Hahnemanns. Hippokrates Stuttg., 1928-29, 1: 386-421. Also J. Am. Inst. Homeop., 1930, 23: 943-71.------■ Die Einstellung der Homoopathie zum heutigen klinischen Denken. Sitzber. Kongr. Liga Homeop internat., 1935, 10. Congr., 112-25.—Thielen. August Biers Anschauungen fiber Allopathic Homoopathie und Isopathie Zschr. arztl. Fortbild., 1939, 36: 232-6.—Traube, J. Physi- kalisch-chemische Betrachtungen fiber die Probleme der Homoopathie. Ibid., 1930, 28: 421-3.—Underhill, E. Illus- trations of the law of similars. Homoeop. Rec, 1936, 51: 253-5.—Underhill, E., jr. Complying with the law of similars J. Am. Inst. Homeop., 1937, 30: 651-3.—Viola, G. Esame della dottrina dell'Hahnemann alia luce dei nostri tempi Riforma med., 1935, 51: 975-8.—Waffensmith, J. W. The ever-present truth of homeopathy. J. Am. Inst. Homeon 1939, 32: 478-80—Ward, J. W. The scope of homeopathy Ibid., 1926, 19: 483-93.—Weir, J. Homoeopathy; a system of therapeutics. Practitioner, Lond., 1928, 121: 213-23. ______- Homoeopathy: an explanation of its principles. Brit. Homoeoo J., 1932, 22: 359-84. Also Homoeoo. Rec, 1932 47- 859-85' Also Ind. Homoeop. Rev., 1932, 41: 320; 1933 42- 354 Also Legge dei simili, 1932, 3: 319; 357; 1933, 4: 12.—Wolff, K Cosa e 1'omeopatia Gazz. osp., 1934, 55: 1445.—Wood, J. C. Is there a scientific, concept of homeopathy? J Am ' Inst" Homeop., 1931, 24: 1238-53. Also repr — Woodbury, B C* Homeonathv: its principles and practice. Hahneman Month' 1931. 66: 506-16.—Young, W. W. The homeooathicity of medical science. J. Am. Inst. Homeop., 1935 28- 391-403 ——— Wells, G. H., & Griggs, W. B. Homeopathic philosophy; the homeopathic trend in modern medical thought Ibid 1941, 34: 268: passim The homeopathic trend in modern medical thought. Ibid., 268; 317; 428- 485- 528 ---- Surgical aspect. Borland, D. M. Homoeopathy in relation to surgery. Brit Homoeop. J., 1935, 25: 12-33.— Butchart, T. R. Surgery in relation to homeopathy. J. Am. Inst. Homeop., 1934, 27: 618.—Castro, D. Homeopatia e cirurgia. Rev. homeop S Paulo, 1941, 5: 18-21.—Coleman, D. E. S. Should the surgeon be a homoeopathic prescriber? Homoeop. Rec, 1936, 51: 268-70.—Linn, G. Homeopathy and surgerv. J. Am Inst' Homeop., 1933, 26: 724.—Manero, J. V., & Landa. E. Ei cirujano frente al ejercicio quirurgico homeopatico. In (Mexico, Asamblea nacional de cirujanos) Lo paraquirurgico, 19;(.V 57-78.—Pulford, A. Homeopathy and the surgeon specialist J. Am. Inst. Homeop., 1937, 30: 91.—Stearns, G. B. Homoeo^ pathic remedies in surgical conditions. Homoeop. Rec, 1937 52: 221-7.—Stevens, G. Homoeopathic remedies as an aid in surgery. Ibid., 1936, 51: 412-5. --- Therapeutics. Allen, H. C. Homoeopathic therapeutics of intermittent fever. 232p. 16? Detr., 1879. Boericke, W. Treatment of disease with the twelve tissue remedies, being a treatise on biochemistry. 194p. 16? S. Franc, 1897. Dewey, W. A. Essentials of homoeopathic therapeutics. 2. ed. 285p. 8? Phila., 1898. ---- Practical homeopathic therapeutics 3. ed. 479p. 8? Phila., 1934. Dunham, C. Homoeopathy, the science of therapeutics. 529p. 8? N. Y., 1877. Lehrbuch der homoopathischen Therapie 8. Aufl. 2v. 1609p. 8? Lpz., 1915-17. Lehrbuch der homoopathischen Therapie; der mannliche Korper [und] der weibliche Korper 412p. 8? Lpz. [1931] Lilienthal, S. Homoeopathic therapeutics 3. ed. 1154p. 8? Phila., 1890 Neatby, E. A., & Stonham, T. G. A manual of homceo-therapeutics: an introduction to the study and practice of homoeopathy. 2. ed 1084p. 8? Lond., 1931. Planer, R. Therapeutisches Taschenbuch zur Einfiihrung in die homoopathische Therapie fiir Aerzte. 327p. 12? Lpz., 1928. .---- Lebrbuch der homoopathischen Thera pie nach dem gegenwartigen Stande der Medizin. 10. Aufl.v v.l. 430p. 8? Lpz., 1931. Stauffer, K. Homootherapie. 851p. 8? Regensb., 1924. Also 3. Aufl. 1051p. 1939. Askenstedt, F. C. CUnical sheet anchors in homeopathic therapeutics. J. Am. Inst. Homeop., 1935, 28: 406-8.— Bauer, H. G. Some mineralogic studies in relation to homeo- pathic therapeutics with indications and clinical app ications. Ibid 1941, 34: 458-64.—Bergmann, J. Homoopathie. In Moghchk. Ther. (K. Klare, & E. Meyer) Stuttg., Bd 3, 1939, 12_3-—-Carmichael, T. H. The advantages of homeopathic prescnbing. J. Am. Inst. Homeop., 1940, 33: 537-40 — Comoaracion (Una) Rev. homeop., Barcel., 1890, 2: 158 — Cookinham, F. H. Acute and chronic remedies. Pacific Coast J. Homoeop., 1935, 46: 303-5.—Delore, P. L'homeo- pathie deviendra-t-elle une thdrapeutique scientifique? Gaz. hop., 1936, 109: 37-43.—Donner, F. Homootherapie, ihr Wesen, Moghchkeiten und Grenzen. Zschr. iirztl. Fortbild., 1936, 33: 490-3— Evans, J. A. The cell as a factor in drug pathogenesis. J. Am. Inst. Homeop., 1933, 26: 725-8.— Farrington, H. The essentials of homeopathic prescribing. Ibid., 1935, 28: 327-9. ------ Symptomatic vs. pathologic prescribing Ibid., 1940, 33: 111; passim.—Fortier-Bernoville, & Klein, S. A. Application and value of the principles of ?no'/.nage and canallzation in homeopathic therapeutics. Ibid., 1936, 29: 400-7.—Friedlander, A. A. Schulmedizin und Homootherapie. Miinch. med. Wschr., 1927, 74: 1597-600 — Gaghardi, G. Le ragioni di una prescrizione omiopatica. Legge dei simih, 1931, 2: 297-303.—Gescher. J. Heilerfolge und Misserfolge in der 'homoopathischen Therapie. Ther. Gegenwart 1937, 78: 57-61.—Gutmann, W. Homoopathie Vi1? Phvsi'5ahsche Therapie. Hippokrates, Stuttg., 1933, 4: 115-28.—Hanchett, W. H. The opsonins-thermotherapy- homceopathy. J. Am. Inst. Homeop., 1909, 1: 560-6 — Henshaw, G. R. An objective method of selecting homeo- pathic remedies. Coll. Papers N. York Homeop. M. College, e *£1: T60-7-—Hinojosa, R. L. One hundred new symptoms of the tissue remedies. J. Am. Inst. Homeop., 1940, 33: l~T lian* F- B- Tne relation between homoeopathy and psychotherapy. Brit. Homoeop. J., 1927, 17: 167-95 — Junkermann, C. F. Specific medication or specific remedy for any one disease. Homeop. Rec, 1939, 54: No. 6, 28-33.— Kayser. La homeopatia en el porvenir. Rev. homeop., Barcel., 1890, 2: 84-9.—Lewandowskl. S. S. Symptoms in HOMEOPATHY 767 HOMER homoeopathy. Homoeop. Rec, 1939, 54: No. 4, 29-35.— Lippe, A. De la importancia de un sfntoma singular. Rev. homeop., Barcel., 1890, 2:172-81.—MacAdam, E. W. Methods of selecting the homeopathic remedy. J. Am. Inst. Homeop., 1933, 26: 847-51.—McGavack. T. H. On the stimulation of natural body defenses homeopathically. Ibid., 1932, 25: 1041.—MacKenzie, G. W. The difference between the orthodox and the homoeopathic diagnostic viewpoints and methods of treatment. Homoeop. Rec, 1940, 55: No. 2, 17-32.—Miranda, G. Individualidad medicamentosa. Rev. homeop., M6x., 1939, 4: 13-9.—Nogu6 Roca, J. Individualizaci6n y generaliza- ci6n. Rev. homeop., Barcel, 1890, 2: 289-97.—Quinton, P. G. Human typology and its application to homoeopathic thera- peutics. Brit. Homoeop. J., 1938, 28: 275-301.—Rabe, R. F. Obstacles to cures by homeopathy. J. Am. Inst. Homeop., 1941, 34: 205-7.—Renner, J. H. Making a repertorial pre- scription. Pacific Coast J. Homeop., 1935, 46: 85-9.—Ricart. TerapSutica homoeopiitica. Rev. homeop., Barcel., 1890, 2: 97-101.—Schier, J. Homoeopathia involuntaria. Hippo- krates, Stuttg., 1938, 9: 501-5.—Schwarzel, F. M. The prognosis of the remedy. J. Am. Inst. Homeop., 1936, 29: 474-6.—Schwarzhaupt, W. Homoopathie. In Moglichk. Ther. (K. Klare, & E. Meyer) Stuttg., Bd 5, 1938, 23-6.— Smith, A. D. The homoeopathic prescription. Pacific Coast J. Homoeop., 1937, 48: 486-8.—Sulzer, F. L. Routine pre- scribing and symptom covering. Hahneman. Month., 1941, 76: 813-20.—Underhill, E., jr. Symptomatic duplications and their evaluation. Homoeop. Rec, 1936, 51: 228-30. Prescribing for nursing infants. Ibid., 1939, 54: No. 7, 41-3. ----- Diet in its relation to homoeopathic prescribing. Ibid., 1941, 57: 223-5.—Waffensmith, 3. W. Mento-clinical homeopathics. J. Am. Inst. Homeop., 1940, 33: 31.—Wassily, P. Die Anwendung homoopathischer Mittel in akuten Krank- heitsfiillen. Hippokrates, Stuttg., 1934, 5: 286-90. Die Homoopathie und ihre Beziehung zu psychophysischen Rassetypen. Ibid., 1938, 9: 1274-6.—Wittriri. Etwas fiber homoopathische Arzneiverordnung, vom Standpunkt des Goburtshelfers und Gynakologen gesehen. Zbl. Gyn., 1939, 63: 393-5.—Wood, J. C. Homeopathy's place in therapeutics. Hahneman. Month., 1938, 73: 265-74.—Zeilinger. E. H. Homeopathic treatment of children's diseases. J. Am. Inst. Homeop., 1939, 32: 487. --- veterinary. Guenther, F. Beziehungen der Homoopathie zur prophy- laktischen Behandlung der Hundestaupe. Berl. tierarztl. Wschr., 1934, 50: 257-60.—Jervis, H. B. F. Applying the law of Hahnemann in veterinary practice. Pacific Coast J. Homeop., 1932, 43: 401. ------ The superiority of homoe- opathy in veterinary practice. Homoeop. Rec, 1940, 55: No. 3, 30-8.—Norr, J. Der homoopathische Arzneischatz dea Veterinarrates Buchner, Munchen. Berl. tierarztl. Wschr., 1939, 55: 133; 149; 175.—Pschorr. Leitlinien zur Einfiihrung in die tierarztliche Homootherapie. Miinch. tierarztl. Wschr., 1938, 89: 181-6.—Rabe, R. F. Homoeopathy in the treatment of animals. Pacific Coast J. Homeop., 1934, 45: 496.—Ver- ordnung des Ministeriums des Innern fiber die Einfiihrung des Homoopathischen Arzneibuchs. Vorschr. sachs. Vet., 1934, 29: 189. HOMEOSIS. See under Metabolism. HOMEOSTASIS. Cannon, W. B. The sympathetic division of the autonomic system in relation to homeostasis. Arch. Neur. Psychiat., Chic, 1929, 22: 282-94. ------ Organization for physio- logical homeostasis. Physiol. Rev., 1929, 9: 399-431. ------ Stresses and strains of homeostasis. Am. J. M. Sc, 1935, 189: 1-14.—Fletcher, J. M. Homeostasis as an explanatory princi- ple in psychology Psychol. Rev., 1942, 49: 80-7.—McDon- ough, F. K. Homoeostasis in the sympathectomized dog. Am. J. Physiol., 1939, 125: 530-46.—White, J. C, & Smith. wick, R. H. Homeostasis. In their Auton. Nerv. Syst., 2. ed., N. Y., 1941, 62-8. HOMEOTHERMY. See Heat [animal] HOME (The) physician and guide to health; a treatise on the prevention and cure of disease; not intended to take the place of the family physician, but to aid the reader in cooperating with him intelligently. 3. rev. ed. 2 p. 1. 926p. incl. illust. 32 pl. diagr. 22^cm. Mountain View, Calif., Pacific press pub. ass. fl938] HOMER, fl. 9. cent. B. C. The Odyssey; with an English translation by A. T. Murray. 2v. xiv, 465p.; v, 455p. 16? Lond., W. Heinemann, 1927-28. u ~7~7r, TThe Iliad> with an English translation ?y A; T-;Murray. 2v. xviii, 579p.; v, 643p. 16? Lond., W. Heinemann, 1925; 1928. See also Botto Micca, A. Omero medico; medici ferite e medicine in Omero 239p. 8? Viterbo, 1930. Also Korner, O. t le b™nesempnndungen in Ilias und Odyssee. 62p. 24 ^cm. J 6110,, 1<70a. HOMERIA. See also Plant, poisonous; Tulip. Gunn. J. W. C. & Brown, H. A. The action of Homeria lucasn. S. Africa M. J., 1932, 6: 459.—Steyn, D. G. Tulip Poisoning. Rep. Dir. Vet. Educ, Pretoria, 1928, 13-14: 197- HOMES, Nathaniel. Daemonology and the- ology. 2 pts 7 p. 1. 239p. 16? London, Th. Roy croft for J. Martin and J. Ridley, 1650. HOMESICKNESS. See Nostalgia. HOMEYER, Helmut, 1914- *Patho- logische Veranderungen an Zahn und Paraden- tium hervorgerufen durch infizierte radikulare Oberkieferzyste. 28p. 22cm. Miinst., H. Buschmann, 1936. HOMICIDE. See also Anthropology, criminal; Autopsy; Cadaver; Capital punishment; Drowning; Elec- trocution; Execution; Infanticide; Manslaughter; Murder, etc. Dublin, L. I., & Bunzel, B. Thou shalt not kill; a study of homicide in the United States. 6p. 4? N. Y., 1935. Redfield, H. V. Homicide, north and south; being a comparative view of crime against the person in several parts of the United States. 207p. 12? Phila., 1880. Davis, L. Violence and public health. Commonhealth, Bost,, 1935, 22: 222-5.—DePorte, J. V., & Parkhurst, E. Homicide in New York State; a statistical study of the victims and criminals in 37 counties in 1921-30. Human Biol., 1935, 7:47-73. Also repr.—Erkkila, S. Statistisch-kriminologische Untersuchung fiber Ausfuhrungsweise von Mord und Totschlag in Finnland in den Jahren 1885-1938. Acta Soc. med. Duode- cim, 1940, ser. B, 28: No. 9, 66-76.—Geographic (The) distribu- tion of homicide in the United States. Statist. Bull. Metrop. Life Insur., 1933, 14: 1.—Hoffman, F. The homicide record. N. England J. M., 1934, 211: 381.—Homicide in America. Brit. M. J., 1935, 1: 1228.—Homicide death rate now definitely declining. Statist. Bull. Metrop. Life Insur., 1939, 20: No. 8, 7-9.—Intervening cause in homicide. Lancet, Lond., 1938, 2: 1133.—Julier. War die Totungskriminalitat der Nachkriegs- zeit wirtschaftlich beeinflusst? Mschr. Kriminalpsychol., 1934, 25: 121-9.—Miner, J. R. Nativity and parentage of the population of the United States and the homicide rate. Human Biol., 1929, 1: 274-8. Also repr.—Morton, J. H. Female homicides. J. Ment. Sc, Lond., 1934, 80: 64-74.— Vallon. Les homicides dus k l'alcool. Mouvement hyg., Brux., 1910, 26: 108.—Wilson, C. M., & O'Neill, M. E. A homicide investi- gation kit. J. Crim., Chic, 1940-41, 31: 357-63. ---- Forensic aspect. See also Cadaver; Death; Injury, etc. Gebele, H. *Pl6tzlicher Tod im Streit oder vorsatzliche beziehungsweise fahrlassige Totung. 35p. 8? Miinch., 1930. Greggers, H. E. *Zur Diagnostik der Halsschnittwunden bei Totung durch eigene oder fremde Hand, p.328-49. 8? Kiel, 1931. Also Deut. Zschr. gerichtl. Med., 1932, 19: Kassel, K. *Die Unzulanglichkeit der aus- seren Besichtigung und Leichenschau im Hin- blick auf die Sektionsbefunde zumal bei stumpfer Gewalteinwirkung. 31p. 8? Munch., 1935. Mauer, K. T. *Weiterer Beitrag zur Ent- scheidung der Frage: Todlicher Unfall durch Absturz oder Totung durch dritte Hand? 20p. 8? Munch., 1934. HOMICIDE / 68 HOMICIDE lieothy. K. [SI:i\ intr by beating] Budapesti orv. ujs., 1936, 34: SM — Curvalho Kranco. (>s crimes de emboscada; homicidas profiv-ionaes. N i -i med. leg. ident., Rio, 193-1, No. 10, 171-4.— Castellanos, I. La investigacion cientffica del liomicidio. Ibid., 1938, 8: 188-96.—Chavigny, M. Vom Kisenbahnzug fiber- fahren: Mord, Selbstmord oder Ungliicksfall? Arch. Krim., 1934, 94: 181-6.—Costa Portela, M. da. Pstatistica das autopsias por homicidio realisadas de 1900 a 1920 ua morgue do Porto. Arch. med. leg., Lisb., 1922, 1: IH, 504.—Del Carpio, I. Un raro caso di vilipendio di cadavere. Arch. antrop. crim., Milano, 1940, 60: 133-6.—Doria, J. K. da C. Perinecroscopia, levantamento de corpo ou inspeccao juridical' Brasil med., 1934, 48: 365-7.—Franchini, A. Contributo alio studio dell'omicidio-suicidio. Arch, antrop. crim., Milano, 1940, 60: 86-110.—Helpern, M. The postmortem examination in homicides. Am. J. M. Jurispr., 1938, 1: 165-76.—Hersch- mann. H. Die Mord-Totschlaggrenze im Strafrecht. Jahrb. Psychiat. Neur., 1931-32, 48: 184-207.—Homicidio; ebriedad paicial; alenuante: emoci6n violenta (documentos judiciales y legislative*) Rev. crim., B. Air., 1928, 15: 570-80— Kauschans- ky, I). M. Die Totung auf Verlangen aus Mitleid in ver- gieichendcr Stiaf^esetzgebung. Mschr. Krim. I'syehol., 1929, 20: 286-90.—Lozano Garza, A. ^Homicidio o suicidio? un caso de telemedicina legal; heridas punzantes y cortantes. Gac. mid. mil., Mex., 1933-34, 1: 363-80.—Martland, H. S. Medi- cal examiners' findings in deaths from shooting, stabbing, cut- ling and asphyxia. Am. J. Clin. Path., 1934, 4: 66-160. Also In Medicolegal Necropsy (Magath) Bait., 1934, 66-160 — Mueller, B. I'nfersuchungen fiber die Befunde an der Schuss- hand nach Abgnl)e von Schfissen mit Trommelrevolvern. Deut. Zschr. gerichtl. Med., 1936, 27: 149-59.—Muller, M. Le diagnostic de l'homicide et du suicide par coup de revolver. Echo med. nord., 1934, 3. ser., 1: 233-8.—Oellrich, W. Totung durch Einfiihrung von Piessluft. Arch. Krim., 1936, 99: 177- 83. ---- Totung ohne Motiv. Ibid., 1938, 103: 194-9 — Olbrvcht. J. [Case for legal medicine; murder, suicide or accident?] Polska gaz. lek., 1936, 15: 293; 317. Il'rcmcdifated or non-premeditated murder?] Ibid.. 1938, 17: 14 I Orlh. Mord oder Selbstmord? ein weiterer Beitrag zu der besonders fiir die Aufklarung von Lebensversicherungs- und Einbi uchversiclierungsbetrug wichtigen Frage der Selbstfesse- lung. Arch. Krim., 1935. 96: 203-8, 2 pl.—Peiper. O. Totung auf Verlangen. Zschr. Medbeamte, 1928, 41: 170.—Perizia medico-legale in un caso di supposto omicidio colposo, in seguito ad ietervc tito niedico-chirurgico. Boll. med. trout., 1929, 44: 543-57.—Pietrusky, F. Vorschliige fiir die Verbesserung der AufUanmg gcwaltsamer Todesfalle. Deut. Zschr. gerichtl. Med., 1930, 26: 16-26.—Pommerol, A. Arrfet de la cour de Rouen du 4 dicembre 1845; homicide par imprudence, medica- ment dangereux, mais relation de cause k effet non d^montree. In his Respons. mid., Lille, 1931, 124.—Raestrup, G. Die gerichtsmedizinische Aufklarung eines fraglichen Monies, zugleich ein Beitrag zur Bcgriffsbestimmung der gerichtlichen Medizin. Oeff. Gesundhdienst, 1940-41, 6: A, 680-95 — Ravicini, S. Omicidio e suicidio. Difesa sociale, -1934, 13: 367-74.—Rode, W. Die Grosse des Einschusses und des Ausschusses; zur Klarung der Frage: Totung durch eigene odor fremde Hand. Arch. Krim., 1937, 101: 77-80.— Schranz, D. [Examination of homicidal and Biiicidal cases] Orv. hetil., 1932, 76: 237.—Silva Riestra, J. Un caso de composicion en delito de homicidio, en Buenos Aires, en el afio 1010. An. Soc. argent. crim., 1937, 3: 19-26. Also Rev. psiquiat. crim., B. Air., 1937, 2: 275-82— Stcinklauber, W. Mord oder Selbstmord durch Halsschnitt? Widerlegung der belastenden Zeugenaussage der eigenen Tochter durch den arztlichen Sachverstandigenbeweis. Deut. Zschr. gerichtl. Med., 1940, 34: 342-5 (microfilm) — Siisskind, D. I. [Die Schadeldegeneration als differenzial- diagnostisches Mittel zur Erkennung von Mord und Selbst- mord] Sudeb. med. ekspertiza, 1930, No. 14. 48-50.—Tobben, H. Die Totung auf Verlangen. Deut. Zschr. gerichtl. Med., 1937-38, 29: 443-52.—Valentino, V. Homicidio ou suicidio? Arq. polfc civ. S. Paulo, 1941, 2: 187-92—VandeGrift, W. II. Suicide and homicide bv violence. Med. Clin. N. America, 1941, 25: 423-36.—Veiga de Carvalho, H. O 5. e o 6. quesito do formulario processual nos casos de homicidio. Arch. Soc. med. leg. S. Paulo, 1939, 10: 56-60.—Walcher, K. Die vitale Reak- tion bei der Beurteilung des gewaltsamen Todes. Deut. Zschr. gerichtl. Med., 1936, 26: 193-211. ---- Psychological and psychiatric aspect. Catjsse, G. *L'affaire Caserio; etude de medecine legale et de psychopathologie historique. 86p. 8? Par., 1934. Mohr, P. *Psychologische Grundlagen zum Delikt des Mordes und des Totschlages. 22p. 24cm. Zur., 1938. Also Schweiz. Arch. Neur. Psychiat., 1938, 41: Petzelt, K. *Zur Psychologie der Totung und Totungsversuche aus sexuellen Motiven. 48p. 8? Bresl., 1933. Puyn, H. T. *Beitrage zur Psychopathologie von Mord und Totschlag [Bonn] p.66-97. 8° Berl., 1930. Also Allg. Zschr. Psychiat., 1930, 93: Sekebrinsky, B. El psicodiagnostico de Rorschach en los homicidas. 19Np. 23'icm C6rdoba, 1941. Bender, L., A Curran, F. J. Children and adolescents who kill. J. Crim. Psychopath.. 1939-40, 1: 297-322.—Benon, R. Perversity homicide k l'asile. Ann. med. 16g., 1936, 16: 466-80.—Carlier. Obsession homicide. J. neur. psychiat Brux., 1933, 33: 522 (>. Gonzalez Enrfquez, K. I.os fen6mc- nos autom&ticos en la genesis del homicidio. .Medicina, Mix. 1933, 13: 49-57.- Hall, J. K. Human behavior: on regression' South. M. & S., 1936, 98: 603.—Heuyer, G., & I.agache, I). Syndrome d'infhience symptomatique d'une encephalite, \m- pulsions suicide et homicide. Ann. mid. psychol.. Par., 1933, 91: pt 2, 214-20.- Homicidio; estado de inconscieiicia, einocioii violenta [a trial] Kev. psiquiat.. crim., M. Air., 1941, 6: 99- 104.—Imber, I. Considerazioni sopra un caso di onhcidiu schizofrenico. Note psichiat., Pesaro, 1936, 65: 161-70. Julier. Kriminalpsychologische (lodanken zu einem Tot- schlagsprozess. Mschr. Kriniinalpsychol., 1935, 26: 516-23.— Kluge, E. [Reflex impulsive homicide] GycVyaszat, 1(139,79; 288.—Krekekr. Ueber den Fall R., einen paranoiden schizo- phrenen Totschlairer. Allg. Zschr. Psychiat., 1936, 105: 79-87.— Krivy. Ilomieide a l'etat subconscient chez un debile pfiriodiquement d.\ sthymique et pers6cut6. Rev. neur., I'm., 1937, 67: 643.- I.ehrman, P. R. Some unconscious determin- ants in homicide. Psychiat. Q., 1939, 13: 605-21. Lopez Bancalari, E.. tk Delpiano, J. Homicidio en estado de emocion violenta. Prensa mid. argent., 1937, 24: 1761. Impulsion homicida determinada por intoxicaci6n alcoholics aguda. Ibid., 1209-12.—Rathmell, T. K., & Corrin, K. M. Retrospective studv of a case in which homicide was involved Arch. Neur. Ptsvchiat., Chic., 1939, 41: 638-41. Also .1 Nerv. Ment. Dis., 1940, 91: 316-22. Robertson, P. ('. Tl„ man that kills. Arch. Neur. Psychiat,., Chic, 1938, 39: 414.— Serebrinsky, II. Psicodiagnostico de Rorschach e inventario personal de P.enreuler en los homicidas. Kev. psiquiat. crim., B. Air., 1911, »i: 603 10 -Stransky, 10. Ian beineikenswerter Fall homizider Inipulshandlung. Psychiat. neur. Wschr., 1934, 36: 292; 302. Strassmann, G. Zur Beurteilung voii Totungsdelikten unter Alkoholwirkung. Allg. Zschr. Psychiat 1926, 85: 371-82— Zimbler, M. The homicidal 'insane' Delaware M. J., 1938, 10: 98-101. HOMM, Bruno Adolf Willy, 1884- *Dic Ueberschatzung des Wertes der verlangsamten Senkungsreaktion, insbesondere bei Magener- krankungen [Berlin] 47p. 23cm. Charlottenb., K. & R. Hoffmann, 1936. HOMMAGE a la memoire du Professeur Jean Cantacuzene. xvii, 822p. illust. pl. diagrs. 4? Par., Masson & cie, 1934. HOMMAGE au Professeur Pierre Delbet. 41p. 8? [Par. E. Arrault & cie, 1910] HOMMEL, August, 1899- *Psychia- trisch-neurologische Symptomenbilder bei Poly- cythaemia rubra (mit Krankengeschichten und Auswertung zweier Falle mit doppelseitiger Chorea und Aphasie) 47p. 8? Erlangen, K. Dores, 1930. HOMMEL, Emma, 1911- *Das Elektro- kardiogramm bei Herzinfarkt [Munchen] 19p. 21cm. Giinzburg-Donau, K. Mayer, 1938. HOMMEL, Herbert, 1908- *Dic akute Appendicitis jenseits der ersten 48 Stunden; ein Bericht uber 300 Intermediiir- und Spatfalle [Leipzig] 16p. 23^cm. [Zeulenroda, A. Ober- reuter, 1935] HOMMENS, Erich, 1911- Organisa- tion und Durchfiihrung der Schulzahnpflege. 23p. 8? Bonn, L. Neuendorf!, 1935. HOMMENS, Eugen, 1903- ♦Untersuchun- gen iiber die histologischen Veranderungen der Wurzelhaut bei Periodontitis acuta. 30p. 8? Munch, [n. pub.] 1927. HOMMENS, Paula, 1909- *Thvmus und Basedow. 19p. 8? Wurzb., R. Mayr, 1934. HOMO. See Anthropology; Man, etc. HOMOEOPATHIC (The) pharmacopoeia of the United States. See American Institute of Homoeopathy. Committee on Pharmacopoeia. The homoeopathic pharmacopoeia of the United States. 5. ed., rev. 680p. 24cm. Bost., 1938. HOMOEOPATHIC 769 HOMOSEXUALITY HOMOEOPATHIC (The) recorder. Glendale, Calif., v.l, 1886- HOMOEOPATHISCHES Arzneibuch. 2. Aufl. viii, 441p. 8? Lpz., W. Schwabe, 1934. HOMOGENTISIC acid. See Alkaptone. HOMOLOGY. See also Anatomy; Morphology. Friedrich, H. Kritische Studien zur Geschichte und zum Wesen des Begriffes der Homologie. Zschr. ges. Anat., 3. Abt., 1932, 29: 25-86.—Naef, A. Zur Diskussion des Homologiebe- griffes und seiner Anwendung in der Morphologie. Biol. Zbl., 1926 46: 405-27.—Wilson, E. R. The embryological criterion of homology. In Biol. Lect. Wood's Hole, Bost., 1896, 101-24 HOMOPTERA. See also Insect; also names of families as Aphididae; Coccidea, etc. Metcalf, Z. P. The Fulgorina of Barro Colorado and other parts of Panama, p.277-423. 8? Wash., 1938. Oman, P. W. Revision of the nearctic leaf- hoppers of the tribe Errhomenellini (Homoptera: Cicadellidae) p.163-79. 8? Wash., 1938. Ferris, G. F. Contributions to the knowledge of the Coc- coidea (Homoptera) Microentomology, 1936, 1:2; passim. ----- The genus Aspidiotus (Homoptera: Coccoidea: Diaspididae) Ibid., 1941-42, 6: 33-69. ------ & Murdock, G. E. Contributions to the knowledge of the Coccoidea (Homoptera) Ibid., 1936, 1: 115-22.—McKenrie, H. L. The genus Aonidiella (Homoptera: Coccoidea: Diaspididae) Ibid., 1938, 3: 1-36.—Miller, F. W. Variations in the secretory cycle of the digestive epithelial and salivary gland cells of aphids (Homoptera) Abstr. Theses Univ. Pittsburgh, 1933, 9: 197-202.—Sampson, W. W., & Drews, E. A. A review of the Aleyrodidae of Mexico; las especies mexicanas de la familia Aleyrodidae, Insecta, Homoptera. An. Esc. nac. cienc. biol., Mix., 1940-41, 2: 143-89.—Speyer, W. Die Embryonalent- wicklung und das Ausschliipfen der Junglarven von Psylla mali Schm. Zschr. wiss. Insektb., 1929, 24: 215-20.—Sulc, K. Les glandes cirieres et leurs productions chez les larves des cixines homopt^res. C. rend. Soc. biol., 1929, 100: 579-83. HOMOSEXUALITY. See also Cunnilingus; Dementia, schizo- phrenic; Effemination; Hermaphroditism; Sex inversion; also in 3. ser. Sexual instinct, In- version. Kronfelb, A. Ueber Gleichgeschlechtlichkeit (Erklarungswege und Wesensschau) 43p. 8: Stuttg., 1922. Kropveld, A. Homosexuahteit en homo- sexueelen. 34p. 16?* Waelburgh [1921] Stekel, W. Onanie und Homosexualitat (die homosexuelle Parapathie) 2. Aufl. 527p. 8? Berl.. 1921. Allen, C. Homosexuality. In his Sex. Pervers., Lond., 1940, 79_84— Biddle, S. G. Homosexuality. In Cyclop. Med. (Piersol-Bortz) Phila., 1940, 12: 844-52—Bovensiepen, R. Homosexualitat. In Handworterb. Sexualwissensch. (Marcuse) Bonn 1923, 215-23.—Curran, D. Homosexuality. Practi- tioner, Lond., 1938, 141: 280-7.—Dupre, E. Les inversions instinctives. Rev. neur., Par., 1912, 20: 744-60—Essay (An) on sexual inversion, homosexuality, hermaphroditism. Med. Critic, 1923, 25: 247-60.—Hirschfeld. Besprechungen von Hirschfelds Buch; Die Homosexualitat des Mannes und des Weibes. Vjahrb. wiss. human. Kom., 1917, 17: 87-102 — Ingram, K. Homosexuality. In his Sex-Morality, Lond., 1940, 99-130.—LaBine, A. C. Homosexuality: the invert. Kep. Wayne Co. M. Soc, 1933-34, 4: 103-5.—Meyer, E. Vom Traifc* lpu>s der Antike zur Homosexualitat der Gegenwart. Zschr. Sexwiss., 1929, 16: 225-35.—Oberndorf, C. P. Homo- sexuality. N. York State J. M., 1922 22: 176. Also repr- Ostwald, W. Die Homosexualitat. Vererb. Geschlleb., 1927, 92-4 —Praetorius, N. Die Bibliographic der Homosexualitat aus den Jahren 1908 und 1909. Vjahrb. wiss. human. JK om., 1909-10 1- 36-106 ------ Die Bibhographie der Homo- sexualitat aus den Jahren 1908 und 1909. Ibid., 1910-11, 2: 319-41 ______ Die Bibhographie der Homosexualitat aus dem Jahre 1910. Ibid., 1911-12, 3: 321.—Raffalovich, A L'amour homosexuel. Arch, anthrop. crim Par 1910, 25. 291-4.-Rogge, H. C. [Homosexuality! Ned. tschr. geneesk., 1922, 66: pt 2, 1068. Also Geneesk. gids, 1936^ 14: 687, 716 — Smith, F. C. Pederasty. Med. World, 1940 58., 18o.— Stekel, W. Homosexualitat. Wien. med. Wschr., 1920, 70. 1409.—Weatherhead, L. D. Inversion or homosexuality. ln his Mastery of Sex, 9. ed., Lond., 1940, 151-7.—Wiemann, A. Menschenfreunde. Jahrb. sex. Zwischenstufen, 1919, 19: 134-43.—Willoughby, R. R. Homosexual relationships. Monogr. Soc. Res. Child Develop., 1937, 2: No. 3, 31-5 — Winsco, J. P. The real homosexual. Sexology, 1934-35, 2: 635-9. ---- Anthropology. Schwarz, O. Ueber Homosexualitat; ein Beitrag zu einer medizinischen Anthropologie. 8? Lpz., 1931. Barahal, H. S. Constitutional factors in psychotic male homosexuals. Psychiat. Q., 1939, 13: 391-400.—Dobkowsky, T. Gebissuntersuchungen an homosexuellen Mannern. Zschr. Sexwiss., 1923-24, 10: 199.—Henry, G. W., & Galbraith, H. M. Constitutional factors in homosexuality. Am. J. Psychiat., 1934, 13: 1249-70. Also repr.—Weil, A. Die Korpermaasse der Homosexuellen als Ausdrucksform ihrer spezifischen Konstitution. Berl. klin. Wschr., 1921, 58: 1225. ------ Die Korpermasse der Homosexuellen als Ausdrucksform ihrer besonderen sexuellen Veranlagung. Jahrb. sex. Zwischenstufen, 1921, 21: 113-38.—Wortis. J. A note on the body build of the male homosexual. Am. J. Psychiat., 1936-37, 93: 1121-5. ---- Casuistics. Ltjstig, L. *Ein Fall von Homosexualitat. 22p. 8? Giessen, 1925. Brandenberg, F. Kasuistische Beitrage zur gleichgeschlecht- lichen Vererbung. Arch. Rassenb., 1910, 7: 290-305.—Drei deutsche Griiber in fernem Land; ein Bericht in gebundener Form. Vjahrb. wiss. human. Kom., 1909-10, 1: 31-5.—Duck. Ein sexualwissenschaftlich interessantes geistliches TJrteil. Zschr. Sexwiss., 1928-29, 15: 348-50.—Flint. A. A case of sexual inversion probably with complete sexual anesthesia. N. York M. J., 1911, 94: 1137.—Funt, J. Human documents in homosexuality. Med. Rev. of Rev., 1935, 41: 551-99.— Gordon, A. The history of a homosexual; his difficulties and triumphs. Med. J. & Rec, 1930, 131: 152-6.—Helweg, H. H. C. Andersen und die Behauptung seiner Homosexualitat. Zschr. ges. Neur. Psychiat., 1928-29, 118: 777-88.—Hirschfeld, M. Gedanken eines Sexualforschers zum Fall Hussmann. Umschau, 1928, 32: 949-51.—Marcuse, M. Ein Fall von Geschlechtsumwandlungstrieb. Zschr. Psychoth. med. Psy- chol., 1915, 6: 176-92. ------ Ein Fall von periodisch- alternierender Hetero-Homosexualitat. Mschr. Psychiat. Neur., 1917, 41: Orig., 185-9.—Meyer, E. Aerztliche Gedanken zum Hussmann-Prozess. Miinch. med. Wschr., 1928, 75: 2143.—Moll, A. Medizinische und psychologische Betrach- tungen zum Prozess Franz. Zschr. iirztl. Fortbild., 1923, 20: 151-5.—Miiller-Hess & Hiibner. Die sexual pathologischen, psychiatrisch-psychologischen und gerichtlich-medizinischen Lehren des Hussmannprozesses. Deut. Zschr. gerichtl. Med., 1929, 14: 158-98.—Praetorius, N. Ein homosexueller Ritter des 15. Jahrhunderts (nach dem Buch von Heinrich Witte: Der letzte Puller von Hohenburg) Vjahrb. wiss. human. Kom., 1911-12, 3: 207-30. ■------ Cambacer£s, der Erzkanzler Napoleons I. und sein P>uf als Homosexueller. Ibid., 1912-13, 4: 23-42. ------ Zwei franzosische Dichter des 17. Jahr- hunderts (Th£ophilie de Viau und Jacques Valine Des Barreaux) und ihre Beziehungen zur Homosexualitat. Zschr. Sexwiss., 1918-19, 5: 95-108. ------ Die Homosexualitat des Prinzen Heinrich von Preussen, des Bruders Friedrichs des Grossen. Ibid., 1928-29, 15: 465-76. ------ Voltaire und die Homo- sexualitat. Ibid., 571-9.—Ronge, P. H. [Complicated case of homosexuality] Geneesk. gids., 1933, 11: 357-67.—Rcss, T. A., & Gillespie, R. D. Progression and regression in 2 homo- sexuals. J. Neur. Psychopath., Brist., 1926-27, 7: 313-31.— Roubinovitch, J., & Borel, P. Un cas d'uranisme: enlevement de mineur par un inverti. Encephale, 1913, 2: 117-31, pl.— Sander, E. Der Priester und der Messnerknabe; nicht von Oscar Wilde. Jahrb. sex. Zwischenstufen, 1920, 20: 152-9.— Schiller, G. A. Beobachtungen gleichgeschlechtlichen Fuhlens. Mschr. Harnkrankh. sex. Hyg., 1928-29, 2: 181-6.—Soltysik, M. [Unusual case of sodomy] Lwow. tygodn. lek., 1914, 9: 448-50.—Vinchon, J. Corydon devant ses confreres. Progr. mdd., Par., 1925, 40: 57.—Young, The problem of the inverted pseudo-hermaphrodite. Urol. Cut. Rev., 1941, 45: 678. ---- Endocrine aspects. Ribeiro, L. Homosexualismo e endocrinologia. 246p. 24cm. Rio, 1938. Baur, J. Homosexuality as an endocrinological, psychologi- cal and genetic problem. J. Crim. Psychopath 1940-41, 2: 188-97 —Blanchard, R. Le virilisme et l'inversion des caracteres sexuels- leurs rapports avec les glandes genitales interstitielles. Bull, med.. Par., 1916, 30: 409-12.—Cooper, W. L. Sex hormone assays as expert evidence. Med. Leg. Crim. Kev., Lond., 1939, 7: 374-7.—Kinsey, A. C. Homosexuality; criteria for a hormonal explanation of the homosexual. J. Clin. Endoer 1941, 1: 424-8.—Ribeiro, L. O problema medico- legal do homo-sexualismo; sob o ponto de vista endoenmco. Arch. med. leg. ident., Rio, 1936, No. 12, 145-60, 20 pl.----- Homosexualitat und innersekretonsche Drusen. Aerztl. 227475—vol. 7, 4th series- -49 HOMOSEXUALITY 770 HOMOSEXUALITY Sachverst. Ztg, 1937, 43: 301-3. ------ Homosexualismo e endrocrinologia. Arch. med. left, ident., Rio, 1937, 7: 167-70. —----■ Homosexuality et glandes endocrines. Ibid., 1938, Xo. 15, p. xcviii- c.------Homosexualismo e endocrinologia. Ibid., 1940, No. IS, 204-6—\\ right. C. A. Kndoerine aspects of homosexuality. Med. Rec, N. Y., 1935, 142: 407; 1938, 1 17: 449. ---- female [Tribadism] Baur, II. *Beitrage zur Genese der weiblichen Homosexualitat [Basel] 32p. 8? Mulhouse, 1937. Chioeckel, M. Female sex perversion, the sexuallv aberrated woman as she is. 331p. 8? N. Y. [1935] ^Vtruiar, A. A. de. ITn caso de homo-sexualidade feminina. Auli. med. leg., Lis!.., 1932. 5: 142-54.—Allen. ('. A case of homosexuality, with neurotic svmptoms in a woman. In his Sex. IVrvers!, lord., 1940. 124T6.— Blrk. -*. M. [Case of • pose- u:-Hit in n yovnrr eill] Ned. tschr. sronccsk., 1929, 7?: ..!i0.- I- n. I 'I til adisr- o • iraliir o- 1.,. ' ex. As. n d ai ■ ■ i., 193S .'2: 17:.- lr.it. .<. ' ei-, i i ribadie. Zschr. Scxuiss.. 1928-29. 1..: 559-71.—I'rrel. O. Pomosexualitat 111 'I \\ eil lichkeit; von einer physioloirischen Form weiblicher Homosexualitat. Mschr. Psychiat.. 1933. 85: 165-9.— Chavijjny. Un cas d'homos>exualit6 feminine. Ann. mid. psychol., Par., 1930, 88: pt 2, 37-41.—Deutsch. H. Ueber die weibliche Homosexualitat. Internat. Zschr. Psychoanal., 1932, 18: 219-41.------On female homosexuality. Psychoanal. Q., 1932, 1: 484-510. ----— Homosexuality in women. Internat. J. Psychoanal., Lond., 1933, 14: 34-56.— Fantis, E. L. Homosexuality in growing girls. Sexology, 1934-35, 2: 348- 50.—Ford, C. A. Homosexual practices of institutionalized females. .1. Abnorm. Ps\ ehol., 1928-29, 23: 442-8.—Genter, G. [Abnormal sexual irMinet in women] J. akush., 1914, 29: 741-6.—Goldschmidt, E. Zwei Falle weiblicher homosexueller Fursorgezoglinge. Zschr. Sexwiss., 1928-29. 15: 253-8.— McMurtrie, D. C. Psychology of a tribadistic uxoricide; a Lombrosian case record. Urol. Cut. Rev.. 1914. 18: 480.— Michaclis. H. Aus den Briefen der Elisabeth Charlotte von dileaus i |i;:,2-1722) Vjahrb. wiss. human. Kom., 1912-13, 13: 62; pass-mi.--Pachcco e Silva. A. ('.. ifc Mattos, (). de. I'm iniciessante caso de homosexualismo feiuinino. Aich. Soc. med. leir. S. I'.iulo, 1939, 10: 69- 81 .—Petit, G. Ambivalence et homosexuality dans la manie et l'excitation cyclothymique; le virilisme maniaque. Ann. mid. psychol., Par., 1933, 91: pt 2, 70.— Saussur, R. de. Les fixations homosexuelles chez les femmes niwrosics. Rev. fr. psychanal., 1929. 3: 50-91.— Schmitt, I,. Ein Beitrag zur Lehre x-on der u eil-lichen Homo- sexualitat. Mschr. Krim. Psychol., 1926, 17: 216-23.— Schwarz, O. Zur Psychologie des Velterlebons und dei Fienidhcit ulargelcgt an einem Fall von I lomosexualitiit) Zscbi. ges. Neur. Psychiat., 1932, 139: 97-132. ------ Zur Psychologic des Welterlebens und der Fremdheit; iiber die weibliche Homosexualitat. Ibid., 1932-33, 143: 478-505 — Shibkov, A. 1. [Irene (she is also Arefiy) Demidova; case ol female urniiu;! Vest. obsh. hig. sudeb. prakt. med., 1913, 49: 889-94.—Wittels, F. Motherhood and bisexuality. Psychoanal. Rev., 1934, 21: 180-93.—Young, K. Sexual inver- sion. In his Person. & Probl. Adjust., N. Y., 1941, 580-3. ---- Forensic aspect. Klake, R. Homosexualitat und Strafrecht. 172p. 8? Hamburg [1937] Maurer, H. Paragraph 175: eine kritische Betrachtung des Problems der Homosexualitat. 62p. 8? Miinch. [1921] Oscar Wilde: three times tried. 484p. 8! Lond. [1906?] Biihme. Die neuen Gesetze iiber Kastration und Homo- sexualitiit. Munch, med. Wschr., 1935, 82: 1330.—Bondy, H. Ueber die Sexualparagraphen im tschechoslowakisohen Ent- wurf des Strafgesetzbuches. Verh. Internat. Koimt Sexual- forsch., 1928, 1. Congr., 5: 1-29.—Burger-l'rinz. H. Betrach- tungen iiber einen Homosexualitatspi ozess. Mschr. Kriminalb 1938,29:333-6. ------ Ueber das Problem der Homosexuali- tat. Ibid.. 1941, 32: 32-9.—Colin, H. In cas d'uranisme; crime passionnel commis par l'inverti. Ann. m6d. psychol Par., 1910, 10. ser., 3: 69-86.—Fischer, I. A homosexuality is annak forensikus mSltatasa. Elme is idegkort., Budap., 1909, 6: 5-24.—Freimark, H. Ziichtbarkeit der Homosexuali- tat. Sex. Probleme. Frankf., 1910, 6: 865-71.—Hegner, T. [A judicial case of homosexuality] Cas. 16k. Cesk., 1923, 62: 448; 1921, 68: 554. —Hellwit;. A. Homosexualitat und Straf- reehtsreform. Deut. med. Wschr., 1911, 37: 312.—Hennessy, M. A. R. Homosexual charges against children. J. Crim Psychopath.. 1940-41, 2: 524-32.-Henry, G. W., & Gross, A. A. The homosexual delinquent. .Vent. Hyg., Alb., 1941 25: 420-42.-Herzog. A. W. Homosexuality- and the law' Med. Leg. .1.. X. V.. 1917, 34: 1-3 Hillrr. K." Pomosexurdis- mub und Fcin-cher A'orcntvi f. y=chr. Frim. Psychol., 1911, '■'. -t '!v. --- — Tas Fcrlii i ber sich selbst. 1 cue Cenera- T4-'C- I.ir ilfcid, 1\ . I eter den FcgrifT der Widernaturlichkeit. Vjahrb. wiss. human. Kom., 1911-12 3: 282-96. ------- Homosexualitat und Stiafroehtsrefonn' Deut. med. Wschr., 1911, 37: 551. Hommoy. Sur un caa d'attentat aux moeurs texamen d'un enfant victime de ma- noeuvres p6do. 5, 11; 49.— Oleena, R. L'omosessualit\ negli ultimi romanzi francesi. Rass. stud, sess., 1923, 3: 271-6.—Praetorius. N. Homo- sexuelle lnseiate. Anthropophyteia, Lpz., 1909, 6: 167-76. —---Leber gleichgeschlechthchen Verkehr in Algerien und Tunis. Ibid., 19)0, 7:179-88. ------ Homosexuellearabische Liebegedichte. Ibid., 189-95.------ A propos de l'homo- sexualite en Allemagne. Arch, anthrop. crim., Par., 1912, 27: 114-6.------La questione dell'omosessualitl in Ger- mania nell ultimo cinquantennio. Rass. stud, sess., 1922, 2: 148-57.—Schulte-Vaerting. Der Homosexuelle als staatlicher Typus. Zschr. Sexwiss., 1927-28, 14: 426-8.—Taube, O. von. Ein homosexueller Romanheld bei Balzac. Jahrb sex Zwischenstufen, 1913. 13: 174-90.—Witry. Hommes poli- tiques homosexuels. Rev. psychothGr., Par., 1912-13 27- 174-7. ---- Treatment. Frey, E. *Peitrag zur Frage der Behandlung und Heilbarkeit der Homosexualitat. 31p. 8° Zur., 1931. Alao Schwcu. Arch. Neur., 1931, 28: 100-25. Allen, C. A case of homosexuality having schizophrenic trends successfully treated by psychotherapy. In his Sex Pervers., Lond., 1910, 11(3-21.—Barahal, H. S. Testosterone in psychotic male homosexuals. Psychiat. Q., 1940, H: 319-30.—Bien, K. Why do homosexuals undergo treatment'' Med. Rev. of Rev., 1931, 40: 5-18.—Engelmann. V. Die kontrare Sexualempfindung, ihre Beziehungen zur Intersexu- alitat und ihre Beeinflussungsmoglichkeit (lurch die Ilonnono der Nebenniere (zugleich ein Beitrag zum Problem der Vcr- miinnlichung resp. Verjiingung) Arch. Frauenk., 1933, 19: 160-7.—Homosexuality and lesbianism treated with metrazol Comment. Owensby Clin., 1940, 5: 2.—Jentzer, A. Inverti et exhihitionnistes psVchopathes gueri.i par la castration. Schweiz med. Wsehr., 1938, 68: 476-8.- Kirov, Y. I. [Heterotrans- plantation in a case of homosexuality] Vrach. delo, 1928, 11: 1587-90.—Lilienstein. Gibt es eine induzierte Homosexualitat und kann sie psychotherapeutisch beeiuflusst werden? l'sy- chiat. neur. Wsehr., 1927, 29: 203-8. Meyer, W. Konnte ca eine chcmisch-physiologische Diagnose und eine erfolgreiche Therapie der echten Homosexualitat geben? Ibid., 1937, 39: 307-10.—Naftaly, L. Perversi6n sexual (homosexualidad) curada. Rev. As. med. argent., 1931. 48: 422-4.—Owensby, N. M. Homosexuality and lesbianism treated with metrazol; preliminary report. J. Nerv. Ment. I'is., 1940, 92: 65.----- The correction of homosexuality. Uroh Cut. Rev., 1941, 45: 494-6.—Riedner, K. Cure of homosexuals? Sexology, 1933- 34, 1: 490-2.—Rudolf, G. de M. The experimental effect of sex-hormone therapy upon anxiety in homosexual types. Brit J. M. Psychol., 1941, 18: 317-22.—Stekel, W. 1st Homo- sexualitat heilbar? Nervenarzt, 1929, 2: 337-43. Also Psycho- anal. Rev., 1930, 17: 443-51. Also Bull, med., Par., 1931, 45: 636-40.—Vinchon, J., & Nacht. S. Considerations sur la cure psvchanalytique d'une nevrose homosexuelle. Rev. fr. psychanal., 1930-31, 4: 677-709.—Wright, C. A. Results of endocrine treatment in a controlled group of homosexual men. Med. Rec, N. Y., 1941, 154: 60. HOMOZYGOSIS. See also Gen; Genetics. Bonnier, G., & Nordenskiold, M. Studies in Drosophila melanogaster with attached X's; frequency of homozvgos's. Hereditas, Lund, 1939, 25: 477-90.—Fortuyn, A. B. D. The importance of homozygous laboratory mice. Chin. M. J., 1936, 50: 1759-66. , HOMP, Ursula, 1909- *Beeinflussung von Gelbkeimen mittelst Passagen durch Pflan- zensafte. 19p. 8? Konigsb., O. Kiimmel, 1935. HOMPESCH [Hans] Maria Aloysius Johannes, 1914- *Ueber die Entwicklung und das fernere Schicksal unserer Fruhgeburten [Bonn] 32p. 21cm. Lengerich, Lengerich. Handelsdr., 1937. HOMRIGHAUSEN, Wilhelm, 1906- *Untersuchungen iiber die Art der Zangenex- traktion bei Vorderhaupts- und hinterer Hinter- hauptslage. 47p. 5 tab. 8? Bonn, H. Trapp, 1935. HOMSY, Antoine Edouard Gaston, 1912- *Contribution a l'etude de 1Tepid^miologie et de la prophylaxie de la m6ningite cer6brospinale 6pidemique. 46p. 8? Par., E. Le Francois, 1937. HOMSY, Fernand, 1900- *Historique de la peste en Egypte. 52p. 8? Par., L. Arnette, 1932. HOMUTH, Andreas Paul Werner, 1907- *Ueber Icterus infectiosus (Weilsche Krankheit) in Leipzig. 63p. 23cm. Lpz., A. Edelmann, 1936. HOMUTH, Heinz Giinter, 1911- *Die Bedeutung des defekten Gebisses fiir die Ent- stehung des Lippen-, Zungen, und Wangen- carcinoms. 51p. 23cm. Berl., R. Pfau, 1937. HONAN, William Francis, 1866-1935. Davidson, L. R. [Obituary] J. Thorac. Surg., 1936-37, 6: 118-20.—Memorial services. J. Am. Inst. Homeop., 1935, 28: 708-10, portr. HONCAMP, Otto, 1902- *Ueber einen Fall von multiplen Carcinomen im Kehlkopf. p.438-42. 8? Jena [n. pub.] 1932. Also Arch. klin. Chir., 1932, 171: HONDA, Tadao, -1928. Nagayo. M. Obituary. Gann, Tokyo, 1929, 23: No. 1. HONDA'S TUMOR 773 HONEY HONDA'S tumor. See Rat sarcoma. HONDURAS. See also British Honduras. Strong, W. D., Kidder, A., II., & Paul, A. J. D., Jr. Preliminary report on the Smith- sonian Institution—Harvard University archeo- logical expedition to northwestern Honduras, 1936. 129p. 8? Wash., D. C, 1938. Thompson, J. E. Excavations at San Jose, British Honduras. 292p. 29cm. Wash., 1939. Cave, A. J. E. Report of 2 skulls from British Honduras. Smithson. Inst. Anthrop. Papers, 1939, 59-66, 10 pi.—Gann, T. & M. Archeological investigations in the Corozal District of British Honduras. Ibid., 1-57.—Longyear, J. M., III. A Maya Old Empire skeleton from Copan, Honduras. Am. J. Phys. Anthrop., 1940, 27: 151-4.—Stromsvik, G. Honduras. Yearb. Carnegie Inst. Washington, 1941, No. 40, 292-5.— Strong, W. D. Archeological investigations in the Bav Islands, Spanish Honduras. Smithson. Misc. Coll., 1935, 92: 1-176, 33 pl. ------ Archeological explorations in northwestern Honduras. Pub. Smithson. Inst., 1937, No. 3407, 75-82.— Trik, A. S. Temple XXII at Copan. Contr. Am. Anthrop. (Carnegie Inst.) Wash., 1939, 5: 87-103, 16 pl., 7 charts. --- Public health. Honduras Britiinica. Bol. Of. san. panamer., 1942, 21: 89.—Illanes Beytia, C. La sanidad en Honduras. Ibid., 1929, 8: 527-32.—Ordonez, P. H. La sanidad en Honduras. Ibid., 1936, 15: 209; passim.—Vidal, M. A. Evoluci6n de la sanidad en la Republica de Honduras. Ibid., 1930, 9: 359-63.— Zepeda, R. B. La sanidad en Honduras: su desarrollo. Ibid., 1937, 16: 301-8. HONDZIEKTE. See Babesiasis. HONEGGER, Friedrich. *Beitrage zur Kennt- niss der degenerativen und entziindlichen Ver- anderungen der Intima des Herzens und der grossen Gefaszstamme. 53p. 8? Ziir., O. Fussli & co., 1882. HONEGGER, Irene, 1898- histolo- gische Untersuchungen iiber die apikalen Hei- lungsvorgange entpulpter Zahne nach Einwirkung von Chlorphenolkampfermenthollosung und Chlorphenol - kampfer menthol - Jodoformpaste (Methode Walkhoff) auf das gesunde Periodonti- um. 47p. 13 pl. 8? Zur., Buchdr. Bericht- haus, 1932. Also Schweiz. Mschr. Zahnh., 1932, 42: HONEGGER, Max. *Zur Kenntnis des Fluors. 32p. 8? Basel, G. Krebs, 1926. HONEKAMP, Paul. Die Heilung der Geistes- krankheiten durch Sanierung des endokrin- vegetativen Systems mit naturlichen Heilstoffen. 149p. illust. 8? Halle, C. Marhold, 1936. ---- Ueber die Storungen der Harmonie des endokrinvegetativen Systems; ihre Ursache und ihre Heilung durch naturliche Heilstoffe. 2. Aufl. 64p. 24cm. Halle, C. Marhold, 1938. HONER, Adrian, 1906- *Beitrage zur Behandlung der multiplen Sklerose [Wurzburg] 24p. 8? Bottrop, W. Postberg, 1933. HONERVOGT, Adolf, 1908- *Ueber die Erfolge der Behandlung der Korpuskarzmome an der Universitats-Frauenklinik Konigsberg Pr. in den Jahren 1910 bis 1. Oktober 1925. 21p. 8? Konigsb., J. Raabe, 1934. HONESTY. Howells, T. H. Factors influencing honesty. J. Social Psvchol., 1938, 9: 97-102.—Jastrow, J. Sanity of honesty. In'his Getting More Out of Life, N. Y., 1940, 290-/--Kline- berg, O. Attitudes toward property. In his Social -Psychol., N Y 1940 92-101.—Luck, R. Viozentrische Betrachtung der Ehrgefiihle. Zschr. Menschenk., 1935-36, 11: 88-94.— Pressey, S. L., & L. C. Results of certain honesty tests given to a group of rural white children and to 2 groups of Indian children. J. Appl. Psychol., 1933, 17: 120-9. HONEY. See also Bee. Bartels, W. Honig und Kunsthonig. p.298- 361. 25U>m. Berl., 1938. Fellenberu. T. von. Zum Nachweis von Stiirkcdextrin in Honifc. Mitt. Lebensmitteluntersuch., Bern, 1923, 19 19-51 — Fiehe. Leber Honig. Berl. tierarztl. Wschr., 1926, 42: i65r9' ------ Beitrag zur Kenntnis deutscher Honige. /schr. Untersuch. Lebensmitt., 1926, 52: 244-59.----- Ueber Cuba-Honisre. Ibi 1., 1928, 55: 460-6.—Fulmer, E. I., Bosch, W. [et al.] Studies on the control of granulation of Iowa honeys. J. Econ. Entom., 1934, 21: 652-6.—Fylcr, H. M. Honey, the oldest known sweet. Hygeia, Chic, 1938, 16: 59-61.—Gallois, G. Le mial artificijl ou sucre inverti. Nature, Par., 1928, 56: 113-5.—Kohlsdorf, D. Etwos uber Honig. Zschr. ges. Krankenhauswes., 1933, 321.—Lucius, F. Zur Kenntnis des Honigs. Zschr. Untersuch. Lebensmitt., 1926, 51: 351; 1927, 53: 376.—Mayer, C. Einiges uber die Entstehung des Honigs. Deut. med. Wschr., 1937, 63: 65.— Noronha, A. Contribuicao para o estudo do mel em Portugal. J. Soc. farm, lusit., 1933, 98: 19; 31; 43; 67.—Some facts about honey; colour, taste and storage. Pharm. J., Lond., 1940, 91: 86.—Vignes, H. Le miel. Aesculape, Par., 1938, 28: 223-30.—Zoneff, I. Bulgarische Bienenhonirre und -wachse. Zschr. Untersuch. Lebensmitt., 1927, 53: 353-76. ---- Analysis. Braunsdorf, K. Beitrag zur Honiguntersuchung und -beur- teilung. Zschr. Untersuch. Lebensmitt., 1930, 60: 575; passim.—Chalaway, H. D. The determination of moisture in honey. Canad. J. Res., 1932, 6: 532; 1933, 8: 435.—Ellegood, i. A., & Fischer, L. Composition of fireweed honev. Food Res., 1940, 5: 559-61.—Fellenberg, T. von, & Rur-iecki, W. Bestimmung der Tnibung und der Farbe des Honigs. Mitt. Lebensmitteluntersuch., Bern, 1938, 29: 313-35.—Fiehe, J. Ueber die Zusammensetzung der Schaumschicht des Honigs. Zschr. Untersuch. Lebensmitt., 1926, 52: 242-4. ------ Ueber die Zusammensetzung und Beurteilung von Zucker- futterungshonig. Ibid., 1928, 55: 169-73. ------& Kordatzki, W. Neue Wege der Honiguntersuchung. Ibid., 1929, 58: 69-77.—Griebel, C. Zur Pollenanalyse des Honigs. Ibid., 1930, 59: 63; 197. ------ Zur mikroskopischen Pollenanalyse des Honigs; Auslandshonig. Ibid., 1931, 61: 241 306. Also in Handb. Lebensmittelchem. (E. Barnes) Berl., 1938, 5: 362-79.—Gruss, J. Eine Methode zur Erganzung der Honig- analyse. Zschr. Untersuch. Lebensmitt., 1932, 04: 376.— Halphen, G. Etude de la reaction de Fiehe. Ann. fn'.sif., Par., 1912, 5: 105-15.—Hitchcock, J. D. Laboratory and held tests of chlorine treatment of honey combs. J. Leon. Entom., 1936, 29: 695-904.—Kisevetter, V. V. [Determination of amino- acids for distinguishing natural honey from artifiei >'■] Gig. epidem., 1930, 9: 11-7.—Kruisheer, C. I. Der Nachw is von kunstlichem Invertzucker in Honig und Honigbackwaren mittels der Lavulosin-Methode. Zschr. Untersuch. Lebens- mitt., 1932, 63: 413-24.—Kuramoto, M. Beitrage zur Kenntnis der Honigprazipitation. Okayama igakkai zasshi, 1934, 46: 1114.—Laband, L., Bartels, W., & Fauth, A. Beitrag zur Beurteilung von Honig. Zschr. Untersuch. Lebensmitt., 1931, 61: 56.—Lynn, E. G., Englis, D. T., & Milum, V. G. Effect of processing and storage on composition and color of honey. Food Res., 1936, 1: 255-61.— Marshall, C. R., & Norman, A. G. The analysis of mixtures of glucose and fructose with special reference to honey. Analyst, Lond., 1938, 63: 315-23.— Martin, E. C. The hygroscopic properties of honey. J. Econ. Entom., 1939, 32: 660-3.—Maurizio. A. Untersuchungen zur quantitativen Pollenanalvse des Honigs. Mitt. Lebensmittel- untersuch., Bern, 1939, 30: 27-69, 2 pl.--Minder. Die Mikro- skopie des Honigs. Mikrokosmos, Stuttg., 192.5-26, 19: 150-5.—Moreau, E. Etude biologique des miels. Ann. falsif., Par., 1911, 4: 65. ------ Analyse biologique des miels. Ibid' 145-8 ----- Valeur de la reaction de Fiehe dans I'analyse chimique des miels. Ibid., 1936, 29: 22-5—Muttelet, F. Le miel ct son analyse. Ibid., 1911, 4: 192-6. ------ & Moroy, J. Documents analytiques sur les miels francais. Ibid., 1923, 16: 344-51.—Nielhammer, A. Die mikroskopische Pollenanalyse bohmischer Honigsorten. Zsclir. Untersuch. Lebensmitt., 1928, 55: 467; 1929, 57: 537.—Orban, G., & Stitz J Die Fluoresconz der Honige im ultravioletten Licht. Ibid' 56: 4f57-71.—Plahl, W., & Fiirstcnau-Obadalek, E. Ueber einen Honig von aussergcwohnlicher Zusammensetzung. Ibid 1937, 73: 148-53.—Ronnet, L. Le miel de champagne; rlocumcnts'analytiqiies. Ann. falsif., Par. 1911, 4: 427-9.— Schou S A., & Abildgaard, J. Leber die Unterscheidung von Honigund Kunsthonig. Zschr. Untersuch. Lebensmitt., 1934,68: 502-11 —Schuette, H. A.. & Rcmy, K. Degree of pigmentation and its probable relationship to the mineral constituents of honey. J. Am. Chem. Soc. 1932, 54: 2909-13.-Schweizer. C. Zum Nachweis von Auslandshonigen durch baktenologische Prufung Mitt. Lebensmitteluntersuch., Bern, 15»28, 19: 117-25—Slitz J Zusammensetzung unganscher Honige aus den Komitaten Baranya und Somogy. Zschr Untersuch Lebensmitt., 1928, 55: 608-10----- Die Photoakt.vitat des Honigs. Ibid., 1930, 59: 606.. ---— & Koczkas J. Die Ultraviolettabsorption des Honigs. Ibid. 60. 420-5. Stoecklin. L. La reaction de Fit he dans 1 analyse des miels. Ann. falsif., Par.. 1912, 5: 116-2l.-Stoldt. W. Nachweis von HONEY 774 HONEY Honig in Gemischon mit Kunsthonig. Zschr. Untersuch. Lebens- mitt., 1934, 67: 435-41—Thaler, H. Zur Mikr. <=kopie des Bienenhonigs. Ibid., 1935, 69: 405-7.—Zander, E. Unter- suchungen iiber die gcformten Bestandteile des IIoiuls. Ibid., 1932, 63: 313-29. ---- Chemistry. Blair, G. W. S. The thixotropy of heather honev. J. Phvs. Chem., 1935, 39: 213-9.—Dingemanse, E. Ueber das Vorkom- men von brunsterregenden Stoffen im Bienenhonig. Acta brevia neerl.. 1938, 8: 55-8.—Dold, H., Du. D. H„ & Dziao, S. T. Nachweis antibakterieller, hitze- und lichtemofindlicher Hemmungsstoffe (Inhibine) im Naturhonig (Btutenhonig) Zschr. Hyg., 1937-38, 120: 155-67.—Elser, E. Weitere Beitrage zur quantitativen Bestimmung der Aschenbestand- teile des Honigs. Zschr. Untersuch. Lebensmitt., 192S, 55: 246-51.—Fellenbcrg, T. von. Melezitosehaltige Rottannen- honige der F.ime 1938. Mitt. Lebensmitteluntersuch., Bern, 1938, 29: 271-6.------A Rusiecki. W. Phosphorsiiurebe- stimmungen in Honig. Ibid., 311-3.—Fiehe, J. Ueber die quantitative Bestimmung des Oxvmethvlfurfurols im Honig. Zschr. Untersuch. Lebensmitt., 1928, 56: 200-3. ------ & Kordatzki, W. Ueber den Sauregrad (die Wasserstofhonen- konzentration) von Honig und Kunsthonig. Ibid., 55: 59-63. ------ Beitnig zur Kenntnis der Dextrine des Honigs und des Kunsthonigs. Ibid., 602-8—Gorbach. G., & Schneiter, R. Zur Frage der Vcrdaulichkcit der Molezitose durch die Biene. Biochem. Zschr., 1938, 296: 367-72.—Gottfried. A. Die Formol! it ration bei der Untersuchung von Honig. Zschr. Untersuch. Lebensmitt., 1929, 57: 558-60.—Laxa. O. Methode nouvelle et simple pour le dosage des all uminoides dans le miel. Ann. falsf., Par., 1923, 16: 286-9.—Lothrop, R. E., & Gertler, S. I. Determination of amino acids and related compounds in honey. Indust. Engin. Chem., 1933, 5: 103-5.—Moreau, E. Identification et dosage des substances protfiques dans les miels. Ann. falsif., Par., 1911, 4: 36-41.—Nottbohm, F. E., & Lucius, F. Melezitose im Honigtauhonig der Lin.de. Zschr. Untersuch. Lebensmitt.. 1929, 57: 549-58.—Paine, H. S., Gertler, S. I., A- Lothrop, It. E. Colloidal constituents of honey; influence on properties and commercial value. Indust. Engin. Chem., 1934, 26: 73-81.—Schuette, H. A., & Huenink. D. J. Mineral constituents of honey; phosphorus, calcium, mag- nesium. Food Res., 1937, 2: 529-38.- Schuette, H. A., & Triller, R. E. Mineral constituents of honey; sulfur and chlorine. Ibid., 1938, 3: 543-7.- Schuette, H. A., & Woessner, W. W. Mineral constituents of honey; sodium and potassium. Ibid., 4939, 4: 3-49-53.—Wahl, O. Untersuchungen uber ein geeignetes Vergallungsmittel fiir Biononzucker. Zschr. vergl. I'hysiol.. 1936-37. 21: 116-42.—Weiss. F. Ueber ein neues \ erfabicii zum Xachweise und zur Bestimmung von Oxy- meth\ Ifurfurol in Honig und Kunsthonig. Zschr. Untersuch. Lebensmitt , 1929, 58: 320-31. ---- Enzymes. Borries, G. Untersuchungen iiber die Vorgiinge beim Treiben des Honigs. Zschr. Untersuch. Lebensmitt., 1934, 67: 65-75.—Braunsdorf, K. Beitrag zur Beurteilung der Honige auf Grund des Diastasegehaltes. Ibid., 1931, 61: 411-20.— Farrell, Leone & Lochhead, A. G. Accessory food substances for osmophilic yeasts: comparison of honev hioactivator with Bios. Canad. J. Res.. 1931, 5: 539-43.—Fellenberg, T. von, & Rusiecki, W. Priifung von Honigen des Jahrgangs 1937 auf Diastase. Mitt. Lebensmitteluntersuch., Bern, 1938, 29: 307-11.— Fiehe, J.. l>er die Anwendung des Honigs anstatt des Zuckers in der Saualinirs- ernahrung. 9lp. 8? Helsin., 1931. Also Acta Soc. med. Duodeeim, 1931, 15: ser. B. (.'sap*'). J. [Honey in infants' feeding] Gyogy.Sszat, 1939 79: 424.- Caudenzi. N. II miele nell'alimenta/'ione itali'wvi con particolare riguardo alia Lombardia. Atti Conv lombarda aliment, pop.. 1938. 1. Conv., rep. 32. 1 17.— Golomb M b [Honey m the diet of children] Sovet. pediat.. 193.", \,,'n' 101-9- Griehel. ('. Vitamin C enthaltende Honige Zsclu' Untersuch. Lebensmitt., 1938, 75: 417-20.- Hauver, E Ft' The miracle of honey. Phys. Cult., N. V., 1941 85- No •>' 44.- Hnydak, M. H. A prolonged test of milk and" honev d'icV Minnesota M., 1936, 19: 774-6. ---- & Palmer I s' Vitamin content of bee foods; vitamin Hi content of rovaj jelly and bee bread. .1. lvon. Entom., 1940, 33: 396. -Heuser O. H. Vitamin C im Honig. Umschau, 1939, 43: 353 _! Hoyle, E. The vitamin content of honey. Biochem I Lond., 1929, 23: 54-60.—Jessup, H. Honey, a natural source of carhohydrate. Trained Nurse, 1934, 92: 490-4.- Husk, M Vitamin C-Gehalt der estnischen Honige. Zschr. Untersuch Lebensmitt., 1938, 76: 543-5.—Lothrop, R. E. The potential alkalinity of honey: its acid-base value as a food. J Nutrit 1936, 11: 511-4.—Reed, E. G. Please pass the honey ' Health Mount. \iew, 1940, 7: No. 7, 13.—Rolleder. A. Untersiu inm' gen iiber den Wert dps Honigs fiir die Ernahrung von Kindern durchgefiihrt in Form sogenannter Honigkuren \r.h' Kinderh., 1933-34, 101: 211 7. -Schlutz, F. W., & Knott' E. M. The use of honey as a carbohydrate in infant feeding J. Pediat., S. Louis, 1938, 13: 465-73. Also repr.—Schuette H. A., & Pearlstein, J. F. Degree of pigmentation and its probable relationship to the diastatic activity of honev Food Res., 1938, 3: 539-41.—Vogel, B. Ueber die Beziehungen zwi- schen Siissgeschmack und Nahrwert von Zuckern und Zucker- alkoholen bei der Honigbiene. Zschr. vergl. Phvsiol 1931 14: 273-347. " ' ---- Hygiene and sanitation. Bahr, L. Die gesundheitliche Bedeutung des Bienenhonins Berl. tierarztl. Wschr., 1934, 50: 321-4.—Belgien. KgV Verordnung betr. Handel und Verkehr mit Honig und iihn- lichen Erzeugnissen (Giitevorschriften) Reichsgesundhbl 1939, 14: 473.—Buttner, G. Beitrage zur Ueberwachung dea Verkehrs mit Honig und Kunsthonig. Zschr. Untersuch Le- bensmitt 1935, 70: 475-80. ------ Ueber den Sulfatgehalt von Tauhomgen. Ibid., 1938, 76: 351-3.—Fiehe, J. Beitrag zur Entmischung des Honigs. Ibid., 1928, 55: 64.—Fiihner. H Oiftiger Honig. Deut. Zschr. Verdauungskr., 1938-39, 1:2 — Kardos, R. F. Herabsetzung des Rohrziickergehaltes von naturhchem Honig. Zschr. Untersuch. Lebensmitt., 1938, 76: ?.5,477-~TKrau??' K- Ueber den giftigen Honig des pontischeii Klemasien. Naturwissenschaften, 1926, 14: 976-8.—Locke- mann, G. Ueber den Arsengehalt von Honig und Bienen nach Verstaubung arsenhaltiger Schadlingsbekampfungsmittel Zschr. Untersuch. Lebensmitt., 1935, 69: 80— Monicault, de La fraude du miel; projet de loi. Ann. falsif., Par., 1921 14- 116-20.—Sartory, A., & Moreau, E. Contribution k l'etude bactenologique de quelques minis. Ibid. 1911 4- 259-63-- Schuette, H. A., & Ihde, A. J. Honey and the lead contamina- tion problem. Food Res., 1939, 4: 555-62.— Sturtevant, A. P. Quantitative demonstration of the presence of spores of Bacillus arvae in honey contaminated by contact with American foul- brood. J. Agr. Res., 1936, 52: 697-704—Szabo, A. [Data on the pathogenic germs in honey] AUatorv. lap., 1938, 61: ---- Therapeutic use. Laborde, J. M. II. Contribution a l'etude du miel des abeilles dans ses applications diet6- tiques et mSdicales. 102p. 25cm. Bord., 1934. Septjlveda Cofre, M. *Miel (La) y sus aphcaciones. 39p. 8? Santiago, 1929. Berardi, A. Virtu del miele quale alimento e medicamento, Med. mf Roma, 1934, 5: 198-207.—Buchner, O. Erfahrun- ^."1," de[ neuen Desitin-Honigsalbe. Zhl. Chir., 1935, 62: " a xt h,accio- F H miele nella terapia moderna. Fol. med Nap., 1933, 19: 317-25.—Groot, J. de [Honey in the treatment of wounds] Geneesk. gids, 1937, 15: 315-8 — Indicazioni terapeutiche e controindica/.ioni del miele. Minerva m*V VLT", 1940^, 31: P1 2' varia. rm (microfilm)—Knott. E. M., Shukers, C. F., & Schlutz, F. W. The effect of honey Uron/Oa,cium retentions in infants. J. Pediat., S. Louis 1941 19: 48.1-94.—Maggiora-Vergano, A. Valore alimentare e propriety terapeutiche del miele. Igiene mod., 1932, 25: ■r7™<— Mul'er- w- Der Honig in ausserlieher Anwendung bei Aampfstoffschadigungen. Med. Welt, 1937, 11: 1781-3 — Muniagurria, C. La miel de abejas en la dietetica normal y '^"w del lactante. Actas Congr. nac. med., B. Air. (1931) 1932 4. Congr., 4: 50-67. ------ Le miel des abeilles dans le diet^tique normale et thdrapeutique du nourrisson. Hull. Soc. pediat, Paris, 1931, 29: 227-45.—Sack. A. Trau- benzucker und Bienenhonig als Niihr- und Heilmittel. Munch. med. Wschr., 1932, 79: 1681-3.—Zaiss. Der Honig in ausser- lieher Anwendung. Ibid., 1934, 81: 1891-3 HONEY 775 HONIG ---- Therapeutic use: Antiseptic value. Dames, W. *Ueber die antiseptische Wirkung des Honigs. 15p. 8? Wiirzb., 1936. Dziao, S. T. *Experimentelle Untersuchungen iiber Inhibine (antibakterielle Hemmungsstoffe) im Naturhonig (Bliitenhonig) [Freiburg] 21p. 21cm. Schramberg (Schwarzwald) 1937. Gabbert, W. *Der Honig als Antiseptikum. 15p. 22cm. Wurzb., 1936. Jahn [M.] H. *Die Einwirkung des Honigs auf Bakterien und Sporen. 23p. 23cm. Lpz., 1937. Action (L') anti-bact6rienne du miel. Bull. sc. pharm., Par., 1940, 47: prof., 136.—D., M. L'action anti-bact6rienne du miel. Presse med., 1940, 48: 716.—Franco, M., & Sartori, L. SuU'azione antibatterica del miele. Ann. igiene, 1940, 50: 216-27.—Gundel, M., & Blattner, V. Ueber die Wirkung des Honigs auf Bakterien und infizierte Wunden. Arch. Hvg., Miinch., 1934, 112: 319-32.—L.. G. Le miel, agent bactericide. Concours med., 1940, 62: 1015.—Prica, M. Ueber die bac- tericide Wirkung des Naturhonigs. Zschr. Hyg., 1937-38, 120: 437-43. HONEYMOON. See also Coitus, initial; Love; Marriage; also Gonorrhea, etc. Boieey, M. Peligros e inconvenientes patol6gicos del viajeo de bodas. Arch. Hosp., Habana, 1940, 11: 225-7.—Chesser, E. S. The honeymoon. In Love essoW. Ein Beitrag zu Hufbeschalg und Hufpflege. Berl. tieriirztl. Wschr., 1933, 49: 229 — ooiVn?'" ,Pe la, seime Stellfeld, C. Hooker filius. Tribuna farm., Curitiba, 1942 10: 7. HOOKER, Joseph Stenson, 1853- The newer practice of medicine. 107p. 8? Lond., C. W. D.nniel co., 1932. ----The humane home doctor; a list, alpha- betically arranged, of the most common com- plaints, with simple home treatments. 99p. 12? Lond., C. W. Daniel co. [1937] HOOKER, Marion Osgood, 1875- Scc Fischer, Mai tin Henry, & Hooker, Marion O. Fats and fatty degenei ation I&<:} 155p. 8? N. Y., 1917. ------ The Ivophilic colloids (their theory and practice) 246p. 8? Springf., 1933. HOOKER, Sanford Burton, 18SS- Allan Winter Rowe, 1879-1934. 8p. portr. 8? [Bost., Boston Univ. Alumni Ass.] 1935. Reprint from Bostonia, Jan. 1935. See also Karsner, H. T., & Hooker, S. B., eds. The 1940 year book of pathology and immunology. 688p. 18^cm. Chic, 1940. Also 1941 ed. 623p. 18!.4cm. 1941. HOOKER, William Jackson, 1785-1839. Stellfeld, C. Hooker. Tribuna farm., Curitiba, 1942, 10: 6. HOOKER, Worthington, 1806-67. Hooker's new physiology, designed as a text-book for institutions of learning. 2v. 376p.; 401p. 8? X. Y., Sheldon & co., 1.874; 1884. ---- First book in physiology; for the use of schools, viii, 191p. 12? N. Y., Sheldon & co., 1883. HOOKWORM. See Ancylostomiasis. HOOL, George A., & JOHNSON, Nathan C. Concrete engineers' handbook; data for the design and construction of plain and reinforced concrete structures, xxiii, 885p. 2 diagr. roy. 8? X. Y., McGraw-Hill Book co., 1918. HOOL, Walter, 1901- *Zur Frage der Reinigung und Desinfektion des Essgesrhirrs in Wirtschaften und offentlichen Anstalten; experi- mentelle Untersuchungen iiber don bakteriolo- gischen Reinheitsgrad. 98p. 24cm. Zur., H. A Gutz wilier, 1928. HOON, Pierra, 1909- *Contribution a l'etude de l'hormonologie gvnecologique. 183p. 8? Par., Maloine, 1936. HOOP, Hans, 1905- *Leistungsfahigkeit und Abnutzung von Zahnbohrern. 19p. 8? Rostock [n. pub., 1930] HOOP, Johannes Hermanus van der, 1887- Xieuwe richtingen in de introspectieve zielkunde van Freud en Jung, vii, 296p. 4? Arnhem, L. Slaterus & Yisser, 1921. ---- *Een geval van schizophrenic; psycho- pathologische studie [Leiden] 3 p. 1. 166p 8? Amst., H. J. Paris, 1924. ---- Bewusstseinstypen und ihre Beziehung zur Psychopathologie. 375p. 8? Bern, H Huber [1937] HOOPER, David, 1858- [Biography] In Oalbrie hervorrag. Ther. & Pharmakogn. Gegenwart, Geneve, 1897, 193; 365, portr. HOOPER, Emmet T. New pocket gophers from the vicinity of Mount Taylor, X'ew Mexico. 13p. tab. 23cm. Ann Arb., Univ. Michigan press, 1940. Forms No. 422. Occas. Papers Univ. Michigan Mus. Zool. ---- Type localities of pocket gophers of the genus Thomomys. 26p. fold. map. 25>km. Ann Arbor, Univ. Michigan press, 1941. Forms No. 52, Misc. Pub. Univ. Michigan Mus. Zool. HOOPER, Robert. Examinations in anatomy, physiology, practice of physic, surgery, chemistry, materia medica, and pharmacy: for the use of students. 3. Am. from the last London ed. 2.">()n 16° N. Y., J. iv H. G. bangley, 1846. HOOPER, William Franklin, 1866- Practical medicine and dietetics. 261 [6]p. S° Oklahoma City, Okla., Med. Book co. [1934] HOOPES, Grace Gertrude, 1X79 Out of the running, xvii, 158p. portr. 8? Springf C. C Thomas [1939] HOOPS, Erich, 1910- *Ueber retro- pharyngeale Abscessc [Kiel] 27p. S? Weser- miinde-Lehe, F. Riemann, 1933. HOOR, Karoly, 1858-1927. Horvath, B. Nekrolog. Klin. Mbl. Augenh., 1928, 80: 97. HOORN, Johan von, 1662-1724. [Biography] In Portr. Svenska lak. apotek. (Sjoberg, N ) Stockh.. 1910. 54. Dortr. HOORWEG, Jacobus. *Over bloeddruk- verhooging, bloeddruk-index en hoogtezonbe- handeling in de zwangerschap. x, 121p. 2 1. 40 diagr. 8? Amst,, H. J. Paris, 1930. HOOSE. See also Bronchitis—in animals. Smythe, R. H. The clinical aspects and Wcatmcnt of hoose (parasitic) and allied conditions in cattle. Nat. \ et. M. Ass. fir. Britain, 1937, 55. Congr., 1-7. Also Vet. Hire., Lond., 1937, 17: 1221-32. HOOTON, Earnest Albert, 1887- The Indians of Pecos pueblo; a study of their skeletal remains; appendix on the dentition by Habib J. Rihan; appendix on the pelves by Edward Reynolds [&c] xxvii, 391p. 50 pl. 4? N. Haven, Yale Univ. press, 1930. ----Up from the ape. xvii, 626p. 28 pl. 8? N. Y., Macmillan co., 1931. ----Apes, men, and morons, viii, 307p. 22cm. N. Y., G. P. Putnam's sons, 1937. ----The American criminal; an anthro- pological study, v.l: The native white criminal of native white parentage; appendix [tables] xvi, 309p. [App. v. p.] 27}vcm. Cambr., Mass., Harvard Univ. press, 1939. ---- Why men behave like apes, and vice versa; or, Body and behavior, xxv, 234p. pl. 22cm. Princeton, Princeton Univ. press, 1940. For biography see Current Biogr., N. Y., 1940, 1: 397-40. HOOVER, Charles Franklin, 1865-1927. Black, J. M. [Biography] Clin. Bull., Clevel., 1941, 5: 72- Obituary. J. Am. M. Ass., 1927, 89: 223. For portrait, photograph, see Collection in library. HOOVER, Herbert Clark, 1874- Emerson, E. Hoover and his times; looking back through the years, xvi p. 632p. 8? Garden City, N. Y., 1932. HOOVER, W. H. The dependence of carbon dioxide assimilation in a higher plant on wave length of radiation. 13p. 3 pl. 8? Wash., 1937. Forms v.95, No. 21, Smithson. Misc. Coll. HOP. See Humulus. HOPE, Edward William, 1857- Health at the gateway; problems and international obligations of a seaport city, xiv, 213p. 13 pl. 2 maps. 3 ch. 8? Cambr., Univ. press, 1931. ---- & STALLYBRASS, C. O. Text-book of public health. 9. ed. x, 340p. 8? Edinb., E. & S. Livingstone, 1926. For 10. ed. see under Frazer, W. M., & Stallybrass, C. 0. HOPE, James, 1801-41. [Biography] In Cardiac Classics (Willius, F. A.) S. Louis, 1941, 402-4, portr.—Flaxman. N. The Hope of cardiology. [Biography] Bull. Inst. Hist. M., Bait., 1938, 6: 1-21. HOPF 779 HOPKINS HOPF, Friedrich Gunther, 1899- *Ueber das Vorkommen tertiiirer Hautsyphilis bei Tabes dorsalis, Paralysis progressiva, Lues cerebro- spinalis usw. [Munchen] 17p. 8? Borna Lpz., R. Noske, 1929. HOPF, Gerhard [Georg William] 1909- *Grossenunterschiede der Muskelfaserquer- schnitte zwischen den einzelnen Portionen des M. masseter beim Menschen und bei einigen Siiugetieren. p. 195-217. 8? [Lpz., n. pub. 1933. Also Zschr. mikr. anat. Forsch., 1934, 35: HOPF, Karl Heinz, 1907- *Zur Pachy- meningitis haemorrhagica interna [Halle] 41p. 21cm. Ober-Schreiberhau, M. Fiedler, 1937 HOPF, Kurt, 1910- *Die Refraktur [Halle] 31p. 21cm. Zeulenroda, B. Sporn, 1938. HOPF, Richard, 1907- *Zur Osteo- chondritis deformans juvenilis coxae [Zurich] 30p. 8? Laupen, Polygraph. Ges., 1932. HOPFE [Friedrich Karl] Walter, 1910- *Ueber Querlagen. 26p. 8? Greifsw., E. Panzig & co., 1934. HOPFENGAERTNER, Fritz, 1911- *Ueber die Erscheinung und die Behandlung der Thymusvergrosserung bei Kindern. 32p. 22cm Tub., A. Becht, 1936. HOPFENGAERTNER, Hermann, 1906- *Die Korrosionsstrome im Mund. 22p. 8° Tiib., E. Gobel, 1930. HOPFER, Ernst, 1910- *Ueber den Mineralstoffwechsel des Menschen; die Wirkung von Weisskrautgaben auf den Saure-Basen- haushalt. 15p. 20^cm. Jena [n. pub.] 1938. HOPFF, Adolf, 1902- *Die Behandlung des perforierten Magen- und Duodenalulcus mit der Netzmanschette nach A. Neumann [Berlin] 27p. 8? Charlottenb., Gebr. Hoffman, 1930. HOPFF [Emma Elisabeth] Martha, 1912- ♦Weitere Untersuchungen iiber Zahnkeimver- anderungen bei angeborener Syphilis [Heidel- berg] 23p. 21cm. Lengerich, Lengerich. Handelsdr., 1936. HOPFNER, Theodor, 1886- Griechisch- agyptischer Offenbarungszauber; mit einer einge- henden Darstellung des griechisch synkretischen Daemonenglaubens und der Voraussetzungen und Mittel des Zaubers iiberhaupt und der magischen Divination im besonderen. 1. Bd. p. 1. [4] 265 p. 30 illust. 4? Lpz., H. Haessel, 1921. Forms Bd 21 of Stud. Palaeogr. & Papyruskunde (Wessely, C.) ---- Griechisch-agyptischer Offenbarungs- zauber: seine Methoden. 2. Bd. 2 p. 1. 172p. 15 illust. 4? Lpz., H. Haessel, 1924. Forms Bd 23 of Stud. Palaeogr. & Papyruskunde (Wessely, C) HOPHAN, Arnold, 1901- *Die Sauglings- sterblichkeit im Kanton Glarus in den Jahren 1876-1930 [Zurich] 47p. 8? Nafels, Glarner, 1932 HOPITAL (L') Par., v.9-28, 1921-40. HOPKINS, Arthur John, 1864- Alchemy, child of Greek philosophy, x, 262p. illust. pl. portr. facs. diagr. 8? X. Y., Columbia Univ. press, 1934. HOPKINS, Arvah St. Clair, 1894-1940. Merritt, A. H. [Obituary] J. Periodont., 1941, 12: 25. HOPKINS, B. Smith [1873- ] & NEVILLE, Harvey Alexander. Laboratory exercises and problems in general chemistry. New ed. xi, 164p. 8? Bost., D. C. Heath & co. [1931] HOPKINS, Dorothy M. m.ide' 1^8f o?bei;'S ^Te's P°cket encyclopaedia, diary and guide, 1938. 21. ed. 454p. 32? Lond , 1938 HOPKINS, Edward Scott, 1896- Water purification control. 2. ed. ix, 184p illust tab. 8? Bait., Williams & Wilkins co., 1936 ----" BINGER, Walter David [et al.] Elements ot sanitation, xi, 435p. illust. diagr. 23^cm. i\. Y., D. Van Nostrand co., 1939. HOPKINS, Ellice. Life and letters of James Hmton ... with an introduction by Sir W. W Gull. 8 ed. xii, 371p. 12? Lond., Kegan Paul, Trench & co., 1906. HOPKINS, Sir Frederick Gowland, 1861- „or^'?land' H- Biography. Nature, Lond., 1938, 141: 989-93 portr.—Portrait. Body and health (W. Cullis & M. Bond) Lond., 1935, opp. p. 124. Also Collection of portraits in librarv. HOPKINS, George Henry Evans. Mosquitoes of the Ethiopian region. Pt 1: Larval bionomics of mosquitoes and taxonomy of culicine larvae. 7, 250p. illust. 8? Lond., Brit. Mus. Natur. Hist., 1936. See also Jordan, H., Mitchell, J. P., & Hopkins, G. H. E Tropical hygiene and sanitation. 388p. 17cm. Lond., 1939. HOPKINS, Grant Sherman, 1865- Guide to the dissection and study of the blood vessels and nerves of the horse. 3. ed. 80p. 26 pl 31^cm. Ithaca, 1937. HOPKINS, Herbert Oxley. Pancreatic effi- ciency tests in malaria. 8p. 25cm. Kuala Lumpur, Gov. Press, 1929. Forms No. 1, Bull. Inst. M. Res. Malay., 1929. HOPKINS, Johns, 1795-1873. Nature of Johns Hopkins. Eugen. News, 1930, 15: 17. HOPKINS, Margaret Daly. Miss Gay's adventures in first aid. 60p. 8? X. Y., Nation Press Print, co. [1933] HOPKINS, Samuel A. Care of the teeth. viii, 150p. 12? N. Y., D. Appleton & co., 1902. HOPKINS, Ross, 1877-1934. Obituary. J. Missouri M. Ass., 1934, 31: 287. HOPKINS, Sewell Hepburn, 1906- The papillose Allocreadiidae. 80p. 8? Urbana, 111., 1934. Forms No. 5, v.32, Biol. Monogr., Urbana. HOPKINSVILLE, Ky. Western Kentucky Asylum for the Insane. Annual report. Hopkins- ville, 1856/57; 1858/59; 1863-83; 1884/85- 1887/88; 37., 1890/91; 39., 1892/93; 42.-44., 1895/96-1897/98; 49., 1901/02; 1902-4. HOPMANN, Carl, 1904- *Die Entkei- mung kleiner Wasserportionen zum personlichen Gebrauch mittels Rein-Chloramin (Hydrosept) und Versuche einer Wirkungssteigerung durch Zusatzmittel. 31p. 8? Bonn [n. pub.] 1929. HOPLOPLANA. See also Polycladida. Stauber, L. A. The polyclad, Hoploplana inquilina thaisana Pearse, 1938, from the mantle cavity of oyster drills. J. Parasit., Lancaster, 1941, 27: 541. HOPLOPLEURA. See Anoplura; Mallophaga. HOPP, Erwin [Gustav] 1903- *Die Anwendung von Warme in der chirurgischen Zahnheilkunde [Leipzig] 24p. 8? [Zeulenroda, A. Oberreuter, 1930] HOPP, Rudolf, 1911- *Methoden und Hilfsmittel zur Feststellung der Gebiss- und Kieferanomalien in der Kieferorthopadie; eine Zusammenstellung [Frankfurt a. M.] 25p. 8? Bottrop, W. Postberg, 1935. HOPPE [Pfarrer] Deutsche Kruppelheime. vi, 158p. 4? Halle, C. Marhold, 1914. HOPPE 780 HOPPELER HOPPE, Almira W., & HALVERSON, Lucile M. A manual of operating room procedures. xii, 239p. 8? Minneap., Univ. Minnesota press [1937] HOPPE, Erna [geb. Fabi] 1893- *Ueber einen Fall von Poliomyelitis anterior acuta. 28p. 2 1. 8? Lpz. [n. pub.] 1927. HOPPE, Gerhard, 1909- *Die wuchernde Struma Langhans. 13p. 8? Heidelb. [n. pub.] 1931. HOPPE, Gerhard [Wolfgang] 1909- *Die Krampfmischung der Lokalanaesthetica; ihre Beeinflussung durch Mineralsalze und Adrenalin. p.687-96. 8? Konigsb., J. Raabe, 1933. HOPPE, Gustav Adolf, 1902- *Ueber Neurolipomatosis dolorosa und ihre differential- diagnostische Abgrenzung [Berlin] 25p. 8? Charlottenb., Gebr. Hoffmann, 1929. HOPPE, Hans Joachim, 1911- *Ueber Hirnchirurgie an der Chirurgischen Universitats- klinik Greifswald. 23p. 8? Greifsw., H. Adler, 1936. HOPPE, Helmut, 1910- *Paranoische Zustande bei einem Manisch-Depressiven. 39p. 22cm. Konigsb., J. Raabe, 1935. HOPPE, Herbert [Friedrich Wilhelm] 1908- *Herzerkrankungen bei dekompensierter chronischer Tonsillopathie. 24p. 8? Greifsw., H. Adler, 1936. HOPPE, Herman Henry, 1867-1929. Obituary. Arch. Neur. Psychiat., Chic, 1930, 23: 548, portr. HOPPE, Hermut [Fritz Ferdinand] 1911- *l'cber die Entgiftung von Localanasthetika durch Cardiazol. 13p. 22cm. Konigsb., J. Raabe, 1936. HOPPE, Use, 1910- *Klinische Unter- suchungen iiber die prophylaktische und thera- peutische Wirksamkeit von Prontosil auf die postoperative und genuine Angina. 30p. 21cm. Miinch., Hohenhaus, 1936. HOPPE, Joseph, 1870-1931. Bufe. Nekrolog. Psychiat. neur. Wschr., 1931, 33: 325-7. HOPPE, Rudolf, 1910- * Morphologische und biometrische Untersuchungen menschlicher Spermatozoen mit besonderer Berucksichtigung steriler Ehen [Berlin] 23p. 21cm. Schramberg, Gatzer & Hahn, 1937. HOPPE, Walter, 1900- *Ueber einige Verbesserungen zur Intelligenz-Prufungs-methode von Binet-Simon. 52p. 8? Berl., E. Ebering, 1927. HOPPE, Walther, 1908- *Die Sonder- stellung der Chondrome innerhalb der Opera- tionen wegen tibergrosser Tumoren. 19p. 8? Bresl., P. Moser, 1936. HOPPE [Walther] Wolfgang, 1906- *Kostvorschrii'ten fur die Behandlung Zucker- kranker mit kohlenhydratreichen Zwei-Nahr- stoff-Diaten [Leipzig] 35p. 8? [Zeulenroda, A. Oberreuter] 1931. HOPPE, Wilhelmine, 1911- *Ueber die Licht- und Warmebehandlung in der Zahn- heilkunde [Miinchen] 21p. 8? Olpe, F. X. Ruegenberg, 1935. HOPPE, Wolfgang, 1904- *Beitrag zur Behandlung der verzogert heilenden Briiche und Pseudarthrosen [Gottingen] 17p. 8? Lehrte, W. Rumpeltin, 1931. HOPPELER, Hans. Dr Hoppeler's Hausarzt; ein Heilbuch und ein Lehrgang zur Erkennung und Behandlung von Krankheiten und fiir die Pflege der Gesundheit. xiv p. 2 1. 926p. illust. pl. portr. 23}<>cm. Meiringen, W. Loepthien [1933] ---- Lichtstrahlen ins Krankenzimmer; ein Trostbiichlcin fiir Kranke. 2. Aufl. 64p. 18cm. Zollikon, Evangel. Buchhandl., 1939. HOPPER, Mary Ellen. See Lewis, G. AL, & Hopper, M. E. An introduction to medica! mycology. 315p. 2iicm. Chic, 1939. HOPPE-SEYLER, Felix Adolf, 1898- *Ueber die Sakaguchische Reaktion im Harn; iiber das Vorkommen und den Nachweis des Arginins im Cystinurikerharn [Wurzburg] 19p. 8? Lpz., F. C. W. Vogel, 1927. -—■— Die Bedingungen und die Bedeutung biologischer Meihylierungsprozesse [Habilita- tionsschrift; Wurzburg] p.433-66. 8? Miinch., J. F. Lehmann [1930] Also Zschr. Biol., 1930, 90: HOPPE-SEYLER, Georg, 1860-1940. Hoff, F. [Obituary] Deut. med. "Wschr., 1940, 66: 1307, portr. HOPPE-SEYLER'S Zeitschrift fur physio- logische Chemie. Berl., v.l, 1877- HOPPIES, Christianus Emmanuel. *Anthro- pomorpha. [13 1.] 4? Uppsala, 1760. Photostat facsimile. HOPSON, George H. Dr George H. Hopson joins De Laval. Ccrtif. Milk, 1941, 16: No. 180, 13, portr. HOPSTEIN, Paul [Peter Adolf] 1902- *Psychoanalyse und gerichtliche Psychiatrie. 36p. 8? Bonn, L. Neuendorf!, 1927. HOPSTOCK, H[alfdan] 1866-1925. Anatomen Leonardo [da Vinci] 85p. illust. portr. 8? Christiania, Steen, 1919. HOPT, Theo, 1909- *Pankreasverlet- zungen durch stumpfe Gewalt [Munchen] 61p. 21cm. Schramberg, Gatzer & Hahn, 1937. HOPESCH, Albert, 1901- *Kritik und Praxis der Narkose bei chirurgischen Eingriffen im Munde [Frankfurt] 32p. 8? Berl. [n. pub.] 1930. HORA, Sunder Lai, 1896- Ecology, bionomics and evolution of the torrential fauna, with special reference to the organs of attachment. p. 171-282. 4 pl. 29cm. Lond., Harrison & sons, 1930. In Philos. Tr. R. Soc. London, 1930. ser. B, 218. HORACE. See Horatius. HORAK, Joseph, 1884-1934. Slanina, P. Necrology. P. verb. Congr. Soc. internat. chir., 1936, 10. Congr., 1: 223. HORA medica; orgao oficial da organizacao medica de radio-difusao e intercambio cientifico. Rio de Janeiro, v.3, 1939- HORATIUS Flaccus, Quintus, 65-8 B. C. Satires, Epistles and Ars poetica; with an English translation by H. Rushton Fairclough. xxx, 508p. 16? Lond., W. Heinemann, 1926. ---- Horace: the Odes and Epodes; with an English translation by C. E. Bennett, xix, [1] 430 [l]p. 16? Lond., W. Heinemann, 1927. See also Winzen, K. "Medizinisches bei Horaz [Munster] 31 p. 22cm. Lrefeld, 1935. Also Montgomery, D. W. Wine, the revealer; the effects of wine on different people as demonstrated by Horace in the 8. satire of the second book. Ann. M. Hist., 1942, 3. ser., 4: 181-8. HORB, Melanie, 1901- *Die Bedeutung der Provokation mit Lugollosung bei Vulvova- ginitis infantum [Munchen] 16p. 8? Schwab. Gmtind, H. Haar, 1933. HORBER, Alfred, 1907- *La transfusion du sang en oto-rhino-laryngologie. 68p. 8? Strasb., C. & J. Goeller, 1933. HORCHLER, Paul, 1909- *Steigerung der Milchsekretion durch antithyreoiden Schutz- stoff [Giessen] 31p. 8? Hamb., P. Evert, 1936. HORDEIN 781 HORLACHER HORDEIN. See also Barley; Gliadin. Liiers, H. B< richtigung zur Arbeit: Ueber die Identitat von Hordein Bynin. Biochem. Zschr., 1922, 133: 603. HORDENINE. See also Alkaloids; Barley. Dautrebande, L. L'action respiratoire reflexe du sulfate d'hordenine. C. rend. Soc. biol., 1932, 110: 1008.—Raoul. Y Sur la formation de l'hordgnine par un processus d'allure biologique. Bull. Soc. chim. biol., Par., 1937, 19: 675-85. ■----- Nouvelle synthase de l'hord6nine. C. rend. Acad, sc, 1937, 204: 74-6.—Raymond-Hamet. Sparteine et hordenine. Ibid., 1929, 189: 651-3. ------ Ueber die nikotinartige Wirkung des Hordenins. Arch. exp. Path., Lpz., 1930, 158: 187-97. —---- Action de l'hord^nine chez l'animal qui a regu une injection intraveineuse de chlorhydrate d'yohimbine C. rend. Acad, sc, 1930, 190: 974-7. ------ Action de l'hord6nine sur le rein k vaisseaux sectionnes puis anastomoses k ceux du cou. C. rend. Soc. biol., 1933, 113: 386. - Sur les effets cardiaques de l'hord£nine. Ibid., 875-7. Sur Taction hypotensive et vaso-dilatatrice de l'hord6nine. Ibid., 114: 476-8. •------ Sur une propriety physiologique encore inconnue de l'hord^nine. Ibid., 1936, 121: 112-5. ----- L'action nicotinique de l'hord6nine n'est pas supprim6e par l'introduction dans la molecule d'un second oxhydrile ph.■ Baril, (;. beH hormones, ou chiinie des glandes endoctmes. .1. Hotel Dieu Montreal, 1941, 10: 297-356- Barrcnsrhcon. II. K. Leber neuere chemische Krkenntnisse auf dem (iebiele dei Hormone Wien. med. Wschr., 1929, 79: 75; 110.—Bischoff, F. Histone combinations of (he protein hormones. Am. J. Physiol., 1936, 117: 182-7.— Bomskov, G. Chemistry of the hormones' Pharm. J., Lond., 1937, 84: 289.-Buchstab. I,. B. [Chemicai individuality of hormones) Odess. med. J.. 1929, 4:255-04.__ Chemistry (The) of the hormones; one aid i another, the hormones are becoming known as familiar chemical compounds Ther. Notes, Detr., 1935, 42: 113-5- Dodds, K. C. The hormones and their chemical relations. Lancet, Lond., 19.11 1: 931; 987; 1048. ------ Chemistrv of the hormones, ln C\elop. Med. (Piersol-Bortz) Phila., 1939, 5: 553-ii.i. Doisy, E. A., & MacCorquodale, I). W. The hormones. Annual Rev. Biochem., 1930, 5: 315-54.—Drftgiinescu, S. [Notes on pages of the first volume Eigebnissc der Vitamin und Ilornion- forschung (L. Ruzicka & \\ . Stepp.) 1938; Chemistry of hor- mones] Rev. .st. med., Bucur., 1939, 28: 567-79.-Du Vi- gneaud, V. The chemistry of the hormones from a .structural standpoint. Sc. Am. Month., 1935, 40: 138-45.- Ellis, C., & Wells, A. A. Hormones. In their Chem. Action l'\ Ravs rev. ed., N. Y„ 1941, 088-90.—Freud. J., Laqueur, E., & Miihlbock, O. Hormones. Annual Rev. Biochem., 1939, 8: 301-48.—Guggenheim, M. Die Chemie der Inkrete. In Handb. inn. Sekret. (Hirsch) Lpz., 1929, 2: 1. Halfte, 36-167.— Houssay, B. A., Deulofeu, V., & Marenzi, A. D. The hormones Annual Rev. Biochem., 1935, 4: 279-310.—Kendall, E. C. Hormones. Ibid., 1941, 10: 285-336.—Kober, S. Die Hor- mone, bzw. Hormonverwandten mit Lipoidcharakter. In Handb. biol. Arbeitsmeth. (Abderhalden, E.) Berl'., 1938, 5: T. 3 B. 2. Halfte, 937-1026.—Koch, F. C. Hormones. Annual Rev. Biochem., 1940, 9: 327-52.—Mazza, F. P. Chimica degli ormoni e delle vitamine. Boll. Soc. ital. biol. sper., 1933, 8: 945-1000.—Oppenheimer, C. Chemie der Hormone und Vitamine; ein Ueberblick iiber die ncuesten Entdcckungen. Deut, med. Wschr., 1932, 58: 17-9.—Roche. J. Biochimie des hormones thyroidiennes et parathyroidiennes. In R6gul. hormon., Par., 1937, 199-210.—Thompson, D. L., & Collip, J. B. The hormones. Annual Rev. Biochem., 1932, 1: 413; passim.—Timofeeva, A. M. [New achievements in the chem- istry of hormones] Usp. sovrem. biol., 1936, 5: 52-65 — Wintersteiner, O., & Smith, P. E. The hormones. Annual Rev. Biochem., 1938, 7: 253-304. ---- Correlations [antagonism and synergism] Ammon, R., & Dirscherl, W. Fermente, Hormone, Vitamine und die Beziehungen dieser Wirkstoffe zueinander. 451p. 8? Lpz., 1938. Fishbein, M. Harmonious hormones [and] Knowing vs. guessing in medicine. [2, 4]p. 4? [N. Y., 1938] Heinemeier, M. *Ein Beitrag zur Frage des Zusammenwirkens der Hormone (Thyroxin und Prolan im Asherschen Sauerstoffmangelversuch) 46p. 8? Kiel, 1933. M0ller-Christensen, E. Studien iiber das Zusammenspiel von Hypophysen- und Ovarial- hormonen, insbesondere im Lichtc von Para- bioseversuchen. 157p. 8? Kbh., 1935. Seidner, L. Contribution k l'etude de I'antagonisme de l'adrenaline et de certains ex- traits pancr^atiques. 80p. 8? Par., 1933. Abderhalden, E., & Wertheimer, E. Studien uber den Einfluss der Ernahrung auf die Wirkung bestimmter Inkret- stofle; Insulin- und Adrenalinwirkung bei verschiedenartig ernahrten Tieren. Arch. ges. Physiol., 1924, 205: 547-58 — Aloncle. Sur le synergisme de lhormone hypophysaire et de l'hormone thymique. C. rend. Acad, sc, 1931, 193: 199-201.— Cam midge, P. J., & Howard, H. A. H. Observations bearing upon the interrelation of insulin and other gland extracts in metabolism. J. Metab. Res., 1924, 6: 189-205.—Ceresoli, A. II comportamento della tiroide e delle capsule surrenali nei Lrattamento con estratti placentari, ovarici e corpoluteinici. Atti Soc. lombard. sc. mea\, 1924, 13: 290-0, pl.—Courrier, K. Insuline et follieuline. C. rend. Soc. biol., 1928, 99: 1630.— Dirscherl, W. Ueber stoffliche Beziehungen zwischen Vita- minen, Hormonen und Fermenten; zur Frage der Wirkstoffe im Korper. Arch. Kinderh., 1938, 113: 39-54.—Gayet, R. Hormones et vitamines. Rev. prat. biol. appl., Bar., 1938, 31: 161-70. ------ Les vitamines compar6es aux hormones au point de vue de leur comportement physiologique. Ibid., 225-35.—Geiringer, M. Die synergistische Wirkung des Adrenalins und des Thyroxins auf den Farbwechsel der Amphi- HORMONE 783 HORMONE bien, Hyla arborea L., und der Fische, Phoxinus laevis Ag., sowie auf die Reifung der Amphibien, Bufo vulgaris Laur. Arch, internat. pharm. dyn., Par., 1938, 60: 251-8.—Gomperts, C. A., & Pompen, A. W. M. [Synergistic action of the men- formon with the extract of the posterior lobe of the pituitary gland] Ned. tschr. geneesk., 1932, 76: pt 2, 2918-28.—Grab. Vitaminas y hormonas. Dia mid., Xi. Air., 1938, 10: 210-4.— Graber, H. T., & Cowles, R. A. Synergistic effect of anterior pituitary and male hormone. Proc. Soc. Exp. Biol., N. Y., 1932, 30: 384—5.—Kollath, W. Beziehungen zwischen Hormonen, Vitaminen und Fermenten. In Norm. Krankh. Steuerung [&c] (Adam, C.) Jena, 1937, 267-80.—Landau, H. [Hormones and vitamins] Warsz. czas. lek., 1939, 16: 70; 92; 111.— Larson, E.. & Fisher, N. F. Effects of thymus, muscle and pituitary extracts on normal and thvro-parathyroidectomized dogs. Am. J. Physiol., 1928, 84: 330-7.—Leiby, G. M. Com- bined effect of antuitrin S and theelin on weights of pituitary, adrenal and thyroid in the normal rat. Proc. Soc. Exp. Biol., N. Y., 1933, 31: 17—Miescher, K. Der biologische Unter- schied zwischen Hormonen und Vitaminen und ihre Verwertung durch den Forper. Internat. med. W. Schweiz (1937) 1938, 3. Congr.. 447-54. Also Schweiz. med. Wschr., 1937, 67: 1046-8.--Moci.lip, R. C., & Ainslee, H. B. Antagonistic action of posterior pituitary extract and insulin. J. Am. M. Ass., 1925, 84: 1398-400.—Miiller, C. Lntersuchungen uber das integrative Zusammenwirken von Hvpophysen-, Thymus- und Ovarialhormon. Endokrinologie, 1937, 19: 289-92.—Muller. E. F., & Petersen, W. F. Analogous action of insulin and epi- nephrin on the liver. Proc. Soc. Exp. Biol., N. Y., 1925-26, 23: 47-51.—Murlin, J. R. Hormones and vitamins. Med. Today, 1938, 1: 79-81.—Muto, T. Ueber die Wirkung der Hormone auf den intermediiiren Stoffwechsel und die gegen- seitigen Beziehungen der Hormone. Fukuoka acta med., 1929, 22: 75.—Novoa Santos. Secretina e insulina. Arch. med., Madr., 1929, 30: 493-5—Piccinini. G. M. Vitamine e ormoni. Rass. clin. ter., 1932, 31: 375-83.— Rondoni, P. Hormonas y vitaminas. Prensa med. argent., 1934-35, 21: 303-8.—Simonnet, H. Hormones et vitamines. Rec. mid. vit., 1933, 109: 658-80.—Smelser, G. K., & Levin, L. The phenomenon of antagonism bv pituitary extract in the absence of the thyroid gland. Endocrinology, 1941, 28: 233-6 — Soula, C. Hormones et vitamines; essai doctrinal. Presse m6d., 1928, 36: 1284-6.—Thaddea, S. Acciones funcionales reciprocas entre hormonas, vitaminas v fermentos. Actual. med., Granada, 1941, 17: 384; 437.—Tokumitsu, Y. Ueber die Beziehung zwischen den Immunkorpern und Hormonen. Tr. Jap. Path. Soc, 1926, 16: 92. ------ The interrelation- ship between hormones and immune bodies. Acta med. Feijo, 1929, 12: 34-50. Also Japan M. World, 1929, 9: 217-26 — Tsunoda, T. Veranderungen an den endokrinen Organen der Tiere bei der Einspritzung des Schwangerschaftsharns, des Laktiferins, des Oophormins beziehungsweise des Plazental- extrakts. Tr. Soc. path, jap., 1933, 23: 164-75. Veranderungen der endokrinen Organe bei der Emulsion- einspritzung beziehungsweise der Implantation des Hypo- physenvorderlappens sowie bei der Pelanin- oder Ovahormon- einspritzung. Ibid., 1934, 24: 405-14—Vogt.E. Ueber die Beziehungen zwischen Hormonen und Vitaminen. Miinch. med. Wschr., 1927, 74: 2125-8. Also Aerztl. Rdsch., 1934, 44: 321-3.—Watrin, J., & Florentin, P. Action compare de l'insuline et de la thyroxine sur les glandes endocrines. C. rend. Soc. biol., 1929, 100: 111-3.—2uelzer. G. Ueber die Hormon- Vitaminbeziehungen. Med. Welt, 1930, 4: 1251.—Zunz, E., & La Barre. J. Action de la thyroxine et de la thyroglobuline sur l'adrSnalino-secretion. Sunti Congr. internaz. fisiol., 1932, 14. Congr., 269-70. ---- Effect. For special effects see under names of organs. Abderhalden, E. Probleme der Inkretwirkungen. Erg. Physiol., 1925, 24: 176-84.—Bansd, H. W. AUgemeines uber die Wirkung der Inkrete. In Norm. Krankh. Steuerung [&c] (Adam, C.) Jena, 1937, 15-27.—Boenheim, F. Ueber den Einfluss der Inkrete auf die Motilitat des Verdauungstraktus. Zschr. ges. exp. Med., 1923, 32: 179-96.—Bond, C. J. Hor- mones and genetics; being a consideration of some of the factors concerned in the response made by certain tissue cells to hormonic influences. Brit. M. J., 1933, 1: 1085.—Bouin, P. Conditions d'action des hormones sur les elements reactionnels transplants. Bruxelles med., 1929-30, 10: 1160-8.—Brain, E. D. The influence of animal hormones on plants; a review of experimental work. Lancet, Lond., 1937, 1: 1241-3.— Bray, E. A proposito di effetti di ormoni di vertebrati su invertebrati. Atti Soc. sc. med. natur. Cagliari, 1933, 35: 69-71.—Cantilo, E. Comment agissent les hormones? action substitutive et seuil de substitution. Presse med., 1936, 44: 804-7.—Cotte, G., Manceau, P., & Meyer, C. Recherche sur Taction de quelques hormones sur les plantes. Gyn6cologie, Par., 1935, 34: 612-23.—Del Guerra, G. Ormoni e lavoro muscolare. Rass. clin., ter., 1931, 30: 322-8—Derecq. La suggestion organique par les hormones. J. mid. Paris, 1938, 58: 7i_3 —Dodds, E. C. Hormones in medicine and pathology. Brit. M. J., 1935, 1: 22. Also Med. Press & Circ, Lond., 1935, 190: 138.—Dunaevsky, F. L. [Effect of hormones on the succeeding generations] TTsp. sovrem. biol., 1939, 11: 185-8.— Ermanno, C. Azione di alcune sostanze ormoniche sulla contrazione muscolare. Pass. ter. pat. chn., 1929. 1 : 641-9.— Fleisch.nann, W. Zur Frage der Beeinflussung \\ nbelloser 2n,rCo W'!!"^'ierinkrete. Arch. ges. Physiol., 1928-29, 221- 591-3.—FnedemannU., & Elkeles, A. Ueber auxoneurotrope 1QW U« ti^renalm und Hypophysin. Deut. med. Wschr., 1932 58: 923-6.—Gellhorn, E. The effect of hormones on cellular permeability. Ann. Int. M., 1933, 7: 33-44 —Hira- tsuka, G. Pharmakologische Beeinflussung der glomerularen filtration und tubularen Riickresorption; Einfliisse der Hor- mone Tohoku J. Exp. M„ 1937, 31: 171-85.—Hogben, L. T., & Hohson, A. D. The action of pituitary extract and adrena- line on contractile tissues of certain invertebrata. Brit J Exp. Biol., 1923-24, 1: 487-500.—Horn, Z. Ueber die soge- nannte spezifisch-dynamische Wirkung der Nahrungsstoffe- VVlikung von Hormonen auf die Zellatmung. Biochem. Zschr ' 1930, 226: 308-14.—lgonda, P. La faceta cosmol6gica de la nresunta hormona hipofisaria, de la folicuhna y del androsteron Sem.^ med., B. Air., 1938, 45: pt 2, 50-2.—Karczag, I., & Hanak, M. [Effect of hormones upon tissue metabolism in vitro] Orvoskepzes, 1935, 25: jun. kulonf., 12- Katz, G. L., & Leibenson, E. A. Extraits de glandes endocrines et d'organes d animaux 4 sang chaud; leur influence sur le coeur d'animaux a sang chaud in situ, au cours del'intoxication par la nicotine.l'am- moniaque, le chloral ou la morphine. C. rend. Soc. biol., 1929, 100: 569.—Krockert, G. Hormonwirkungen. Klin. Wschr' 1940, 19: 574 (microfilm)—Lee, Y. C. Studies on the influence of hormones on the blood picture of the rabbit. Tr. Jap. Path Soc, 1932, 22: 299-341.—Lim, R. K. S.. & Necheles, H. Demonstration of a gastric secretory excitant in circulating blood by vivi-dialysis. Proc. Soc. Exp. Biol., N. Y., 1926-27, 24: 197.—Medvedeva, N. B. [Specificity of reaction in the invertebrata to the hormones of the vertebrata] J. mid., Kiev, 1937, 7: 923-35.—Montalenti, G. L'azione degli ormoni sul piumaggio degli uccelli. Rass. clin. ter., 1934, 33: 6-24.— Mussio Founder, J. C. Accion local de las hormonas. Rev. As m6d. argent., 1939, 53: 789-96.—Ravenna, P. Azione di alcuni ormoni sulla permeability capillare. Sperimentale, 1930, 84: 165-78—Romeis, B. Methodik der Beeinflussung Wirbclloser durch W irbeltierinkrete. In Handb. biol. Arbeits- meth. (Abderhalden, E.) Berl., 1923, 5: Teil 3 A, 485-90.— Sperti, G. S., Lool'bourow, J. R., & Lane, M. M. Effects on tissue cultures of inter-cellular hormones from injured cells. Science. 1937, 86: 611.—Tada, S., & Nakazawa, F. Hormonale Beeinflussung des kolloid-osmotischen Drucks des Bluts. Tohoku J. Exp. M., 1930, 15: 119-34.—Tangl, H. Ueber den Einfluss einiger Inkretstoffe auf die Farbenausscheidung aus dem Blute. Biochem. Zschr., 1927, 182: 411-7.—Taylor, G. W. The effects of hormones and certain other substances on cell (luminous bacteria) respiration. J. Cellul. Physiol., 1932, 1: 297-331.—Vignali, A. L'indice di coagulability e il tempo di stillicidio sanguigno in ginecologia; azione delle sostanze ormonali. Monit. ostet. gin., 1936, 8: 421-37.— Villa, L., & Cavazzeni, M. Ormoni e funzione renale (con riferimenti al diabete insipido) Policlinico, 1932, 39: sez. med., 128-39.—Von Haam, E., & Cappel, L. Effect of hormones upon cells grown in vitro; the effect of sex hormones upon fibroblasts; and adrenal gland. Am. J. Cancer, 1940, 39: 350-9.—Wohlge- muth, J. Ueber die Beeinflussung des Zellchemismus durch Hormone. Deut. med. Wschr., 1928, 54: 816.—Yosomiya, R. Experimentelle Studien iiber die Einfliisse verschiedener Pharmaka auf die durch progressive Sauerstoffverdunnung entstelienden physiologischen Reaktionen; iiber die Einfliisse der Inkrete und der vegetativen Nervengifte. Tohoku J. Exp. M., 1927, 9: 229- 50.— Ziegelmayer, W. Ueber den Einfluss von Inkreten auf den Quellungszustand von Leuciscus- Eiern. Arch. mikr. Anat., 1924, 102: 359-02. ---- Effect, pathological. Lichtwitz, L. The hormones. In his Funct. Path., N. Y., 1941, 11-20.—Pende, N. Gli ormoni morfogenetici nelle condizioni normali e patologiche. Athena, Roma, 1939, 8: 426-32.—Uehlinger, E., Jadassohn, W., & Fierz, H. E. Mi- toses occurring in the acanthosis produced by hormones. J. Invest. Derm., 1941, 4: 331-5.—Vargas, C. A. Algeria hor- monica, choc hormonioo. Rev. hig., Bogota, 1934, 15: 381- 415.—Vegh. L., & Pallos, K. [Histological changes observed in animal experiments after the administration of large doses of H. H. L. hormone] Magy. orv. arch., 1938, 39: 56-61.— Sylla, A. Steigerung der allergischen Reaktionslage durch Hormone. Klin. Wschr., 1939, 18: 311. ---- Elimination. See also subheading Metabolism. Bowman, D. E., Visscher, J. P., & Mull, J. W. Properties of hormones in the female urine. J. Biol. Chem., 1935, 109: p. xi.—Excretion of hormones in the urine in disease, especially diseases of women. Roche Rev., Nutley, N. J., 1937-38, 2: 363-9.—Excretion of hormones in the urine in normal persons. Ibid., 355-62.—Neumann, H. O., & Peter, F. Die Hormon- ausscheidungen im Kindesalter. Zschr. Kinderh., 1931-32, 52: 24-30.—Rostand, J. Influence de 1'urine de jeune enfant sur les larves de batraciens. C. rend. Soc. biol., 1935, 119: 1054. ---- Estimation, and identification. Antognetti, L., & Geriola, F. Studi sui tests ormonici. Endoer. pat. cost., Bologna, 1933, n. ser., 8: 547; passim — Ci=laghi, F. Metodi rapidi per la ricerca dell'ormone lattogeno e dell'ormone maschile. Med. ital., 1938, 19: 134-6.—Culhane, HORMONE 784 HORMONE K., & Underhill, S. W. F. The estimation of hormones. Ana- lyst, Lond., 1932, 57: 684-98— Graubner. W. Quantitative spekttographische Untersuchungen im ultravioletten Teil des Spektrum; die Hormone und ihr spektrogiapbisches Verhalten. Zschr. ges. exp. Med., 1928, 63: 527-41- Parrot, J. L. Les hormones tissulaires en pathologie; essais de dosages en clini- que. Paris mid., 1938, 107: 497-500.—Tatum. F. L., & Ilaagen-Smit, A. J. Idenlification of Drosophila v+hormone of bacterial origin. J. Biol. Chem., 1941, 140: 575-80. Also repr.—Wolfer, L. Hormone und Vitamine und deren Nach- weis. Med. Klin., Berl., 1926, 22: 372. ---- invertebrate. Hanstrom, B. Hormones in invertebrates. 198p. 221/2cm. Oxf., 1939. Koller, G. Hormone bei wirbellosen Tieren. 143p. 22cm. Lpz., 1938. Von der YVense, T. Wirkungen und Vorkom- men von Hormonen bei wirbellosen Tieren. 80p. 23^cm. Lpz., 1938. Barigozzi, C. Gli ormoni negli invertebrati. In Trattato endoer., Milano, 1: 1939, 113-31.—Bayer, G., & Wense, T. Ueber den Nachweis von Hormonen in einzelligen Tieren; Cholin und Acetylcholin im Paramecium. Arch. ges. Physiol., 1936, 237: 417-22.—Franco de Mello, R. Alguns aspetos da fisiologia dos hormonios em insetos. S. Paulo med., 1941, 14: pt 2, 18-24—Kiihn, A., Campari, E., & Plagge, E. Ueber hormonale Genwirkungen bei Ephestia kuhniella Z. Nachr. Ges. Wiss. Gottingen, math.-phvsik. Kl., 1935, n. F., 2: Biol., 1-30, 2 pl— Kiihn, A., & Piepho, H. Die Reaktionen der Hypodermis und der Versonschen Drusen auf das Ver- puppungshormon bei Ephestia kuhniella Z. Hiol. Zbl., 1938, 58: 12-51.—Plagge, E. Der zeitliche Verlauf der Auslcsbarkeit von Hoden- und Imaginalaugenfarbung dutch den A-Wirkstoff bei Ephestia und die zur Ausscheidung einer wirksamen Menge notige Zeitdauer. Zschr. indukt. Abstamm., 1936, 72: 127- 37. ------ Weitere Lntersuchungen iiber das Verpuppungs- hormon bei Schmetterlingen. Biol. Zbl., 1938, 58: 1-12. ---- Manufacture. Vincke, E. Vitamine und Hormone und ihre technische Darstellung. T. 3: Darstellung von Hormonpraparaten. 162p. 22J^cm. Lpz., 1938. Butenandt. Ixis hormones synthdtiques. In R^gul. hormon., Par., 1937, 789-91. -Carr, C. J. New medicinal products suggested bv scientific research. Bull. School M. Univ. Maryland, 1933, >8: 37-43. — Dirscheri, W. Hormone. U. S. Patent Off., 1939, No. 2,182.073; 3,182.074.—Dodds, E. C. Synthetic hormone analogues. Lancet, Lond., 1940, 2: 572.— Friedrich, H. Stable suspension of hormone preparations. U. S. Patent Off., 1940, No. 2,190,183.—Gustus, E. L. Method of preparing hormones. Ibid., 1938, No. 2,120,405.—Hisaw, F. L., & Fevold, H. L. Isolation and purification of hoimones. Ibid., 1936, No. 2,030,209.—Kjems, H. L. P. Recovery of hormones. Ibid., 1938, No. 2,129,584.—Langecker, H. Con- centration of hormones in secretions of the human or animal body. Ibid., 1935, No. 2,001,255.—Muller, C. Versuche iiber die Gewinnung von Hormonen mit Hilfe einer besonderen Methode der Yivi-Diffusior. Endokrinologie, 1930, 7: 401- 15.—Ruzicka, L. [From Dalmatian insect powder to sexual hormones] Lijec. vjes., 1940, 62: 329-35.—Schoellc-r, W., & Jurkmann, K. Recovery of hormones. U. S. Patent Off., 1937, No. 2,073,354.—Sevag, M. G. Method of separating hormones fiom biological materials. Ibid., 1940, No. 2,202,- 029.—Suit charging infringement of estrone, theelin, patent ended by consent judgment. Hospitals, 1941, 15: No. 10, 122. ---- Metabolism. Daxby, M. Vorming en afbraak van mannelijk hormoon door overlevende organen. 92p. 241/2cm. Assen, 1939. Forbes, T. R. Relative absorption rates of pellets of some crystalline hormones. Anat. Rec, 1941, 79: Suppl. No. 2, 22.—Gedroyc, M. [Morphological elements of the blood as a factor of absorption arid concentration of hormones] Polska gaz. lek., 1933, 12: 970-3.—Kurzrok, R., & Wilson, L. The problem of hormonal distribution as controlled by tissue up- take. Endocrinology, 1940, 27: 166-8— Marrian, G. F. Some aspects of the intermediary metabolism of the steroid hormones. Bull. N. York Acad. M., 1939, 15: 27-42.—Parkes, A. S. Effective absorption of hormones. Brit. M. J., 1938, 1: 371-3.— Selye, H. On the role of the liver in the detoxification of steroid hormones and artificial estrogens. J. Pharm Exp Ther.. 1941, 71: 236-8.—Shimkin, M. B., & White, J. Ab- sorption rate of hormone-cholesterol pellets. Endocrinology, 1941, 29: 1020-5.—Skarzyn^ki, B. [Chemism of hormones] Polska gaz. lek., 1930, 9: 549-51.—Steppun, O. A. [Chemical fate of hormones in the animal bodv] Klin, med., Moskva 1933, 11: 577-81.-Zawadoskwy, B. M. Zur Problemstellung der Physiologie und des Motfuechaels der Hormone im Or- ganismus. Endokrinologie, 1933, 12: 81-90. ---- Pharmacology. See also Hormone therapy. Kleine, E. *Ucber die Abhangigkeit der Wirkung des Insulins und Adrenalins von Appli- kationsart, Korpergewicht, Konstitution und vegetativem System. 39p. Bonn, 1935. Trendelenburg, P. Die Hormone; ihre Physiologie und Pharmakologie. 2v. 351p.; 520p. 8? Berl., 1929-34. Zartmann, O. *Untersuchungen iiber die Wirkung von Blutextrakten auf das isolierte Warmbliiterherz. 28p. 8? Lpz., 1935. Abderhalden, E. Ueber die Bedeutung der im Organismus vorhandenen Bedingungen fiir die Auswirkung von Inkret- stoffen. Arch. sc. biol., Nap., 1928, 12: 26-9. — - Beitrag zum Problem der Inkretwirkungen. J. Psychol. Neur., Lpz. 1928, 37: 7-11. ------ & Wertheimer, E. Studien uber den Einfluss der Ernahrung auf die Wirkung bestiuunter Inkret- stoffe; Insulin- und Adrenalinwirkung bei Verabreichung saurer beziehungsweise basischer Nahrung. Arch. ges. Physiol., 1924, 205: 559-70.— Abel, J. J. Chemistry in relation to biology and medicine with especial reference to insulin and other hoimones. Science, 1927, 66: 307.—Agduhr, E. Injections of hormones may be able to increase the resisting power of the organism against injurious factors. Skand. Arch. Physiol., Berl., 1937, 77: 4.—Alfieri, P. Studies on the action of folliculin and of insulin on glycemia and on diuresis. Surg. Gyn. Obst., 1942, 74: Suppl., 43 (Abstr.)—Asher, L. Die regulative Wirkungs- weise der Hormone und ihre Bedeutung fiir den Arzt. Schweiz, med. Wschr., 1939, 69: 513-5.—Braun, H. Hormone und Hormonpraparate, ihre Chemie, Phvsiologie und Pharmako- logie. Deut. Apoth. Ztg, 1939, 54: 486; 507; 522; 532.— Buschbeck, H. Ueber neue Stoffe mit hormonaler Wirkung. Ber. Phys. med. Ges. Wurzburg (1938) 1939, n. F., 62: 194- 201.—Ceccarelli, G. Azione di alcuni ormoni sulla curva di cicatrizzazione delle ferite cutanee in animali normali e con S. R. E. bloccato. Riv. pat. sper., 1929, 4: 170-98, 4 pl — Clyne, A. J. Hormones. Australas. J. Pharm., 1932, n. ser., 13: 211; 323.—Coghan, W. M., Ganelina, B. S., & Choro- schilova, A. I. [Polyphasic action of hormones] Med. biol. J., Leningr., 1925, 1: No. 3, 43-51.—Corpus luteum, ovary, anterior pituitary, whole pituitary, ovarian residue, suprarenal, deletion of first paragraph. Bull. Nat. Formulary Com. U. S., 1939-40, 8: 2.—D'Amour, M. C. An attempt to duplicate cer- tain hormone responses by means of drugs. Endocrinology, 1934, 18: 235.—Dcanesly, R., & Parkes, A. S. Factors in- fluencing the effectiveness of administered hormones. Proc. R. Soc, Lond., 1937, ser. B, 124: 279-98, 4 pis.—Dernbach, W. Hormone und Hormonpraparate. Arch. Pharm., Berl., 1937, 275: 410-28.—Dodds, E. [Correlation between the chemical structure of hormones and their biological activity] Usp. sovrem. biol., 1937, 6: 143-51.—Dodds, E. C. A study of specificity in relation to hormone and other biological relations, In Harvey Lect., Bait., 1934-35, 30: 119-45.—Fornero, A. Lo scarso valore nutrizio del liquor F. e la sua influenza ormonalo distrofica sullo sviluppo generale, in confronto di altri organi che fanno parte della catena endocrina (placenta, pancreas, milza, fegato) Monit. ostet. gin., 1931, 3: 444-7.—Gaunt, R. Studies on steroid hormones; in lactation; in water metabolism; metabolism of desoxycorticosterone. Yearb. Am. Philos. Soc, 1941, 178-80.—Greenwood, A. W., & Blyth, i. S. S. Some effects of thyroid and gonadotrophic preparations in the fowl. Q. J. Exp. Physiol., Lond., 1941-42, 31: 175-85.—Herb, F. Specificity of the activities of hormones, vitamins and comple- ments. Med. J. & Rec, 1929, 129: 250-4.—Herrnberger, K. Sobre la actividad peroral de la folicuhna, estradiol, y de la hormona luteinica, progesterona. Dia m6d., B. Air., 1941, 13: 716-8.—Horsters, H. Stoffwechselversuche mit Hormon- pniparaten an Kaninchen. Zschr. ges. exp. Med., 1930, 73: 167-79.—Jarisch, A. Allgemein Pharmakologisches zur Hor- montherapie. Aerztl. Prax., Wien, 1936, 10: 173-8. Also Wien. klin. Wschr., 1936, 49: 6-11.—Kogan, V. M., Kamenew, M. J., & Mantz, N. B. Die Mehrphasenwirkung der Hormone. Klin. Wschr., 1926, 5: 221-4.—Kronfeld, A. Die verschiedenen Konstitutionstypen und die M oglichkeit innerer Aenderung. Med. Welt, 1929, 3: 1679; 1753.—Kylin, E. The importance of electrolytes for the working of hormones. Acta med. scand., 1926, 16: Suppl., 288-91.—Lipzschutz. Acci6n antitumoral y antifibrosa de algunas hormonas. Rev. m6d. Chile, 1941, 69: 161.—Loeb, L. On the graded relation between the intensity of hormone action and the character of the recipient-tissue. Endocrinology, 1928, 12: 161-76.—Merz, K. W. Neuere Ergebnisse der Hormoiiforselning. Arch. Pharm., Berl., 1933, 271: 128-40.—Morhardt, P. E. Synlhc se et pharmacologic dee hormones et des vitamines. Presse med., 1932, 40: 966-9.— Nicolas. Le probleme des glandes k secretions interne; les propri6t£s ph\ sic■o-chimiques et pharmaco-dynamiques dea hormones. Bull. Acad. vet. France, 1932, 5: 378-80.—Osborne, W. A. Hormones. Australas. J. Pharm., 1941, 22: 809-11.— Selye, H. Studies concerning the anesthetic action of steroid hormones. J. Pharm. Exp. Ther., 1941, 73: 127-41.—Solov- tzova, A. [Correlation of certain electrolytes and hormones] Vrach. delo, 1929, 12: 29; 111.—Stemmer, W. Die Stellung der Hormone unter den Ganzheitsregelungen des Korpers una HORMONE 785 HORMONE Hormonwirkungen als Arzneimittelbilder. Hippokrates, Stuttg., 1936, 7: 909-17.—Tavastsherna, N. I. [Blood- and cholesterin picture in monkevs after administration of svnihetic hormones] Arkh. biol. nauk, 1935, 40: 137-40.—Zondek. H.. & Bansi, H. W. Hormone und Narkotica. Klin. Wschr., 1927, 6: 1319-21.------Hormone und adsorption. Biochem. Zschr., 1928, 195: 370-86.—Zondek, H., & Ucko, H. Hormon- wirkung und Wasserstoflionenkonzentration. Klin. Wschr., 1942, 3: 2009.------Weiterer Beitrag zur Frage der Variabi- litat der Hormonwirkung. Ibid., 1926, 5: 1861-3. --- Physiology. Abderhalden, E., & Wertheimer, E. Studien iiber den Ein- fluss der Ernahrung auf die Wirkung bestimmter Inkretstoffe. Arch. ges. Physiol., 1924, 206: 451; 1925, 207: 222-27.—Bayer, G Blut und Hormone. In Handb. allg. Hamat. (Hirschfeld) Berl., 1934, 2: 2. Halfte, 1089-144.—Bayer, L. M. Hormones; regulators of the body. Hygeia, Chic, 1940, 18: 532-4 — Carnot, P. Les regulations hormonales en biologie, en clinique et en therapeutique; avant-propos. In R6gul. hormon., Par., 1937, 5-8.—Cazal, P. Les fonctions hormonales chez les 6tres vivants; 6tude de physiologie compar£e. Biol, med., Par., 1939, 29: 545-71.—Champy. C, & Dreyfus, A. Y a-t-il un mecanisme nerveux terminal dans les actions hormoniques? C. rend. Soc. biol., 1937, 124: 640-2.—Dye, J. A. Hormones and their functions in the animal body. Cornell Yet., 1942, 32: 140-54.—Euler, H. von. Hormones et vitamines. In Regul. hormon., Par., 1937, 796-801.—Fitting, H. Die Hor- mone als physiologische Reizstoffe. Biol. Zbl., 1930, 56: 69- 86 —Koch, W. Die praktische Anwendung von Hormonen bei Nutztieren. Erg. Biol., 1938, 15: 1-66.—Kustner, H. Haben Lichtstrahlen einen Einfluss auf die Hormone? Wir- kung im Tier- und Pflanzenreich. Zschr. Geburtsh. Gyn., 1932, 103: 305-17.—Parrot, J. L. La transmission chimique de I'influx nerveux et les hormones tissulaires. Paris med., 1938, 107: 357-68.—Plagge, E. Genabhangige Wirkstoffe bei Tieren. Erg. Biol., 1939, 17: 105-50.—Smith, A. H. Hormones and their functional importance. Rocky Mountain M. J., 1940, 37: 654-9.—Zak, B. R. [Effect of electrolytes on the nature of the excitation actions of hormones] J. Physiol. USRR, 1941, 30: 656-8.—Zuelzer, G. Neue Untersuchungen uber Hormone. Verh. Deut. Kongr. inn. Med., 1910, 27: 581-5. --- plant. See also under names of plants. Went, F. W., & Thimann, K. V. Phyto- hormones. 294p. 8? X. Y., 1937. Adams, A. E. The gonad- and thyroid-stimulating potencies of phvone and hebin. Anat. Rec, 1934, 59: 349-61.—Albers, H. Pflanzliche Wuchsstoffe. In Handb. Biochem. (Oppen- heimer, C.) 2. Aufl., Jena, 1936, Erganz. 3: 815-27.—B., F. Pflanzenhormone. Deut. med. WTschr., 1939, 65: 1638.— Barigozzi, C. Gli ormoni vegetali. In Trattato endoer., Milano, 1939, 1: 87-111.— Chailakhian.M.K. [On the hormone of florescence] Usp. sovrem. biol., 1939, 10: 515-24.—English, J., jr The wound hormones of plants; the synthesis of some analogs of traumatic acid. J. Am. Chem. Soc, 1941, 63: 941-3. -----& Bonner, J. The wound hormones of plants; traumatin, the active principle of the bean test. J. Biol. Chem., 1937, 121: 791-9 Also repr.—Fabre, R. Les hormones vegetales. In Regul. hormon., Par., 1937, 812-25.—Giedosz, B. [Extracts of certain vegetables with effect similar to hormone extracts] Polska gaz. lek., 1935, 14: 753-6.—Joding. Hormone im Pflanzenreich. Jahrber. Ges. Nat. Heilk., Dresd. (1932-34) 1934, 24.—Kholodny, M. G., & Beltiukova, K. I. [Effect of phytohormones on the variability of microorganisms] J. mikrob., Kiev, 1939, 6: 49-67.—Koepfli, J. B., Thimann, K. V., & Went, F. W. Phytohormones: structure and physiological activity. J. Biol. Chem., 1937-38, 122: 763-80.—Kotte, W. Methoden zum Nachweis pflanzlicher W undhormone. In Handb. biol. Arbeitsmeth. (Abderhalden, E.) Berl., 1939, Abt. 11, T. 4, 1. Halfte: 161-6.—Kustner, H. Hormonwirkung bei den Pflanzen und Hormonsteigerung durch rotes Licht. Klin. Wschr., 1931, 10: 1585.—Laibach, F., & Mai, G. Ueber die kiinstliche Erzeugung von Bildungsabweichungen bei Pflanzen. Arch. Entwmech., 1936, 134: 200-6.—LaRue, C. D. The effects of wounding and wound hormones on root formation. Proc. Nat. Acad. Sc. U. S., 1941, 27: 388-92.—Lichtwitz, L. Phyto- hormones; hormones and embryonic development; congenital endocrine disorders. In his Funct. Path., N. Y„ 1941, 17-20.— Mayer, C. Einiges uber pflanzliche Hormone. Deut. med. Wschr., 1937, 63: 1952-4. ------ Untersuchungen mit Pflanzengallen. Ibid., 1938, 64: 17323—Melchers, G., & Lang, A. Weitere Untersuchungen zur Frage der Bluhhormone. Biol Zbl 1942 61: 16-39.—Mitolo, M. Fitormoni. I'isiol. & med., Roma, 1938, 9: 325-39.—Montemartini, L Di alcune azioni ormoniche nelle piante. Boll. Soc. ital. biol. sper 1929, 4: 872-4.—Plant hormone research is awarded J 1,000 by A A A S ■ new substances added to water or mixed with lanolin and rubbed on as salve will develop roots. Science News Lett., 1936, 29: 19.—Rippel, K. Die Bestimmung von Zell- teilungshormonen in pflanzlichen Geweben und Saften. In Handb. biol. Arbeitsmeth. (Abderhalden, E ) Berl 1939, Abt. 12 T 2 Bd 2: 1569-76.—Rouschal, E. Pflanzliche Hormone. Deut. tierarztl. Wschr., 1941, 49: 229-34.—Savelli, R. Sur une action de nature hormonale exercee par le tissu embryonnaire 227475—vol. 7, 4th series----50 de \ icia faba. C. rend. Acad, sc, 1940, 210: 705-7.—Schopfer, W. H. Le facteur M de mucoringe est-il analogue k l'hormone de division cellulaire des m6ristSines (ou k l'hormone reglant la production de matiere de ces cellules)? Protoplasma, Lpz., 1936-37, 27: 131-4.—Stoughton, R. H.. & Plant, W. Regenera- tion of root cuttings as influenced by plant hormones. Nature Lond., 1938, 142: 293.—Thimann, K. V. The hormone control of plant development. Biol. Sympos., Lane, 1941, 4: 213-9.— Tovarnitsky, V. I. [The plant and hormones] Usp. sovrem. biol., 1937, 6: 130-42.—Tschaykovsky, V. K., & Bondarenko. G. Quelques notes sur la substance de l'oignon. Rev. fr endoer., 1936, 14: 40-6.—Turfitt, G. E. A new method for the determination of phytohormone activity. Biochem. J., Lond 1941, 35: 237-44.—Went. F. W. Salt accumulation and polar transport of plant hormones. Science, 1937, 86: 127. ------ Plant hormones. In Pub. Am. Ass. Advance. Sc, 1940, No. 14. 147-58.—Zollikofer, C. De l'influence des hormones animales sur les plantes. Scientia, Bologna, 1938, 64: 66-74. ---- Secretion. See also Endocrine gland. Bomskov, C. Methodik der Hormonforschung. Bd 2: Ovar, Hoden, Hypophysenvorderlappen. 1016p. 25J/2cm. Lpz., 1939. Doods, E. C., & Dickens, F. The chemical and physiological properties of the internal secretions. 214p. 8? Lond. [1925] Laquer, F. Hormone und innere Sekretion. 136p. 8? Dresd., 1928. Reiss, M. Die Hormonforschung und ihre Methoden. 415p. 8? Berl., 1934. Bennett, M. J., Russell, P. B., jr, & Ramsey, L. C. Hor- mones interpreted quantitatively; cyclic variations of some. South. Surgeon, 1941, 10: 164-72.—Frankel, S. Nachweis, Bestimmung und Darstellung der Inkrete der einzelnen (ligane mit Einschluss der Abbaustudien und der Synthese. ln Handb. biol. Arbeitsmeth. (Abderhalden, E.) Berl., 1938, 5: T. 3B. 1. Halfte, 195-268.—Kisch, B. Probleme der allgemeinen Hor- monforschung. Protoplasma, Lpz., 1936, 25: 469-81. Muto, C. On the path of the secretion of hormones: the secretion of the hormones of pancreas and testicle. Tr. Jap. Path. Soc, 1927, 17: 294-9. ---- Psychosomatic aspect. See under Endocrine gland. ---- Standardization and potency. Bugyi, B. [Examination of absorption spectra of the Hungarian commercial hormone preparations] Gyogyaszat, 1938, 78: 466-71.—Cinberg, B. L., & Goldman, S. F. Potency evaluations of commercial female hormone preparations. N. York State J. M., 1941, 41: 864-8.—D'Amour, F. E. The potency of certain commercial hormone preparations; second study. Endocrinology, 1940, 26: 88-92. ----— & D'Amour, M. C. The potency of certain commercial hormone prepara- tions. Ibid., 1938, 22: 583-7.—Freed, S. C. Present status of commercial endocrine preparations. J. Am. M. Ass., 1941, 117: 1175-82—Harms, H. Standardisation of hormone prepara- tions. J. Egypt. M. Ass., 1933, 16: 874-96.—Pak, C, & Read, B. E. Pharmacological standards for the hormone preparations of the Chinese Pharmacopoeia. China M. J., 1931, 45: 125- 33—Report of the third International conference on the standardisation of hormones (Geneva, August 11th to 13th, 1938) Bull. Health Org. League of Nat., 1938, 7: 887-99. ---- Types. Cannon, W. B., & Bacq, Z. M. Studies on the conditions of activity in endocrine organs; a hormone produced by sympa- thetic action on smooth muscle. Am. J. Physiol., 1931, 96: 392-412.—Castaldi, L. Gli ormoni morfogenetici. Studium, Nap., 1926, 16: 208-13.—Collip, J. B. Inhibitory hormones and the principle of inverse response. Ann. Int. M., 1934, 8: 10-3 —Danin, L., & Fecht, H. Florohormon (Sidler) Praxis, Bern, 1926, 15: H. 37, 1.—Loofbourow, J. R., Dwyer, C. M., & Cronin, A. G. Proliferation-promoting intercellular hormones; evidence for their production by living cells as a response to injury. Biochem. J., Lond., 1941, 35: 603-9.—Luisada, A. Gii ormoni locali: istamina e acetilcolina. Rass. internaz. chn. ter 1931 12: 214-29.—Miyagawa, Y. j. On the autohormone. Jap. J. Exp. M., 1930, 8: 185-94.—Orsos, O. Untersuchungen uber die sogenannten Nekrohormone. Protoplasma, Lpz., 1936 26- 351-71.—Richet, C. fils. Les hormones homo- organiques. Presse med., 1920, 34: 486.—Santesson, G. C. Einiges uber die Wirkungen von Nervenreizhormonen sowie von gewissen Nervengiften. Arch. sc. biol., Nap., 1928 12: 20-5 Also Arch. exp. Path., Lpz., 1928, 128: Suppl., 103 — Weichardt W. Ueber Hormone zweifelhafter Natur. Deut. med Wschr., 1930, 56: 258. ------ Ueber aktivierende Spaltprodukte und Gewebshormone. Khn Wschr., 1931 10: J53_5 ------ lTebr>r sosrenannte Gewebshormone. Wien. med. Wschr., 1932, 82: 139-42. HORMONE 7S() HORMONE THERAPY ---- Types: Circulatory hormone. Soe also Heart hormone. Mylenbusch, R. *Untersuchungen zur Unter- scheidung des Kreislaufhormons E. K. Prey von Histamin, Cholin und Hypophvsin [Miinchen] 46p. 21cm. Bielefeld, 1936. Brugsch, T., Horsters, H., & Rothmann, H. Ueber das Wesen der sogenannten hormonalen Kreislaufpraparate. Med. Klin., Berl., 1931. 27: 1378.—Circulation (Tlno hormone. J. Organother.. 1932. 16: 199-204.—Dale, H. Vasodepresso- rische Sioffe. Zsehr. Kreislaufforsch., 1037, 29: 320 — Fichera, S., & Lanza, G. Propriety ipoglicemizzanti degh ormoni circolatori. Riforma med., 1934, 50: 243-53.—Frey, E. K. Leber die therapeutische Verwendbarkeit des Kreislauf- hormons. Arch. klin. Chir., 1929, 157: 399-403.------ Kreislaufhormon und innere Sekretion. Miinch. med. Wsehr., 1929, 76: 1951. ------ & Kraut, H. Ein neues Kreislauf- hormon und seine Wirkung. Arch. exp. Path., Lpz., 1928, 133: 1-56 ------ Nachweis und Wirkung eines Kreislaufhormons. Miinch. med. Wschr., 1928, 75: 763— Frnhlich, A. Kreislaufs- hormone. Wien. med. Wschr., 1928, 78: 1186.—Haberlandt, L. Nachweis und Wirkung eines Kreislaufhormons. Miinch. med. Wschr., 1928, 75: 1079.—Hermann, H., Jourdan, F., & Cornut, P. Sur le passage dans le sang d'une substance vasoconstrictive autre que l'hormone mddullo-surr£nale; sensibilisation de ses effets par la cocaine. C. rend. Soc. biol., 1937, 124: 764-6 — Janovics, A. [Vascular hoimones] Gjogyaszat, 1934, 74: 650-4.—Kraut, H., Frey, E. K., & Bauer, E. Ueber ein neues Kreislaufhormon. Zm hi. physiol. Chem., 1928, 175: 97-114.— Lastman. H. [On the hormones of circulation] Polskie arch. med. wewn., 1931, 12: 525 '!8. -Nito,G. de. Blutdrucksenkende Hormone als Ursache des 1'roteinschocks. Deut. med. Wschr., 1935, 61: 339 41.—Rigler, R. Kreislaufwirksame Oowcbs- produkte. In Handb. exp. Pharm. (A. Heffter) Erganz., Berl., 1938, 7: 63-94.—Schenk, P. Besserung der Gehirn- duichblutung durch Kreislaufhormone zur Beseitigung von Kopfschmerzen, Milderung von Zittererscheinungen und zur Kraftigung gclahmter Gliedcr. Verh. Deut. Ces. inn. Med., 1938, 50. Kongr., 564-9.—Schretzenmayr. A. Leber die Wirkung der sogenannten Kreislaufhormone auf den Gefass- tonus. Zschr. Kreislaufforsch., 1932,24:225-40.—Velden, R. von den. Therapie mit Kreislaufhormon-Praparaten. Deut. med. Wschr., 1931, 57: 619; 672; 712; 753.—Werle, E. Kor- pereigene krcislaufaktive Stoffe. Tn Handb. Biochem. (Oppen- heimer, (.-.) 2. Aufl., Jena, 1936, Erganz., 3: 1081-121.— Zarday, I. [Circulatory hormones] Orv. hetil., 1935, 79: mell., 199. ---- Types: Sex hormone. See also under proper names of sex hormones as Estrogen, etc. Sobering Corporation. The story of sex hormones. [H]p- 18}3p. 24cm. Par. [1937] Schering Corporation. Medical Reskarch Division. Schering's handy index to hormone therapy. 26 1. 8}2 x 13cm. Bloomfield, N. J., 1941. Abdel Hamid Mustafa. Some remarks on endocrine therapy. J. Egypt. M. Ass., 1941, 24: 388-92.—Arnold-Larsen, A. [Hormone therapy] Ugeskr. laeger, 1933, 95: 1147 50.■- Becart. Hormones et hormonotherapie de M. Louis Moinson. Bull. Soc. med. Paris, 1939-40, 157. ---Resume aide- memoire d'hormonothrirapie. Ibid.. 225-30. - Berghmann, H. von. Las hormonas y vitaminas en terapentica. Siglo mecl., Madr., 1936, 97: 318-20.—Bergmann, G. von. Zur Therapie mit Hormonen und Vitaminen. Verh. Berl. med. ties. (1935) 1936, 66: 296-321. Also Deut. med. Wschr., 1936, 62: 289; 333.—Bernhart, F. Zur Hormontherapie. MUnch. med. Wschr., 1938, 85: 1022-4. Blum, F. Ueber einige hormonale Eigenschaften des Blutes und ihre thenipeulische Verwert- barkeit (EK-Tetanie, Morbus Basedouii) Mitt. Grenzgeb. Med. Chir., 1928-29, 41: 569 81.—Dunn, ('. W. Hormone therapy; its uses and abuses. Delaware M. J., 1940, 12: 137-42.- Frohlich, A. Hormontherapie. Wien. klin. Wschr., 1928, 41: 1344-8.—Heimberger, H. Gedanken zur Horinon- behandlung. Hippokrates, Stuttg., 1935, 6: 783-9.—Herbrand, W. (imndsiitzliches zur Hormontherapie. Ibid., 1941, 12: 231-5.—Hormone therapy. In New Modern Drugs (Gutinan, J.), 1936, No. 7, 16.—Hutton, J. H. Practical hormone ther- apy. J. Am. Inst. Homeop., 1938, 31: 389-94.—Jores, A. Fortschritte der Hormontherapy; Grundsatzliches. Fortsch. Ther., 1936, 12: 533-7.—Laignel-Lavastine & Justin-Besancon. Pr^sentent un voeu concernant l'emploi thdrapeutique des hormones. Bull. Soc. med. hop. Paris, 1940-41, 56: 795.— Mallow, S. Hormontherapie in der Praxis. Miinch. med. Wschr., 1938, 85: 1313. -Meyenburg, H. von. Bemerkungen zur Wirkungsweise des Aristotrop. Schweiz. med. Wschr., 1937, 67: 7.—Preobrazhensky, A. P. [Principles of hormonal therapy] Vrach. delo, 1939, 21: 65-70.—Raab, W. Spezifische und unspezifische Hormontherapie. Deut. med. Wschr., 1937, 63: 356-9.—Rodriguez de la Cruz, J. M. Algunos aspectos de la hormonoterapia. Rev. m6d. cubana, 1928, 2. ser., 9: 158- 202.-—Silva Campos, S. da. Hormonio hematogfriico, substi- tuto da transfusao de sangue. Labor, clin., Rio, 1941, 21: 233-41.—Spence, A. W. Recent advances in hormone therapy. Postgrad. M. J., Lond., 1936, 12: 377-82. Also S. Barth. Hosp. J., Lond., 1936, 44: 9-12.—Steppun, O. A. [Physi- ological medicament] Klin, med., Moskva, 1933, 11: 119-22.— Tiflfeneau, M. Hormones synth^tiques et leurs succ&ianes; opoth^rapie synth^tique. In Lecons du dimanche (Carnot, P.) Par., 1933, 3. ser., 180-228.—-Valenti, A. Le nuove concezioni umorali in medicina e due fra le pin recenti applicazioni tera- peutiche. Rass. clin. sc, 1931, 9: 57-03—Willcox, R. Hor- monotherapie. Rev. med., Louvain, 1934, 316-8.—Zachariae, G. Zur Hormontherapie durch Hormotonebehandlung. Aerztl. Rdsch., 1929, 39: 123. ---- Administration, and dosage. Beyer, W. *Untersuchungen zur Frage der parenteralen Hormondepots. 13p. 8? Lpz., 1937. Deanesly, R., & Parkes, A. S. Further experiments on the administration of hormones by the subcutaneous implantation of tablets. Lancet, Lond., 1938, 2: 606-9.—Emmens, C. W. The inunction of sex hormones on the skin. J. Endoer., Oxf., 1940-41, 2: 368-79.—Jores, A. Die Tagesrhythmen in ihrer Bedeutung fiir die Hormontherapie. Med. Welt, 1936, 10: 1542-5.—Lemaire. Les petites doses d'hormones en thdra- peutique. Presse mid., 1937, 45: 47.—Lyford, G. A pre- liminary report on the phasing of hypodermic hormones in the treatment of functional gynecological conditions. J. Med., Cincin., 1938-39, 19: 135-8.—Mussio-Fournier, J. C, Morato- Manaro, J., & Albrieux, A. Action locale des hormones. Presse med., 1939, 47: 844-8. ------ Acci6n local de las hormonas. Acci6n med., B. Air., 1940, 10: 264-7.—Schiller, W. Local application of sex hormones. J. Am. M. Ass., 1941, 117: 473.—Simacek, O. [Percutaneous application of hormonesl Cas. lek. cesk., 1928, 67: 294-6. Also Med. Klin., Berl., 1928, 24: 978.—Walter, F. Hormonwirkung durch die Haut. Umschau, 1936, 40: 264.—Winkler, F. Die enclermatische Einfiihrung von Hormonen. Derm. Wschr., 1929, 89: 1483-0. ---- Indication. Bowes, K. An outline of sex physiology in the female and the clinical applications of hormone therapy. S. Thomas Hosp. Gaz., Lond., 1937-38, 36: 547-52.—Burch, J. C. Endo- crine therapy in gynecology. Phi Chi Q., Menasha, 1934, 31: 519.—Curschmann, H. Ueber Hormontherapie in der HORMONE THERAPY 787 HORMONE THERAPY inneren Medizin. Ther. Gegenwart, 1937, 78: 97-102.— Dodds, G. H. Hormone therapy in obstetrics and gynaecology. Clin. J., Lond., 1941, 70: 207-12. Also Nurs. Times, Lond., 1941, 37: 524; 551; 562.—Enke, W. Hormontherapie bei konstitutionellen Funktionsstonmp;en. Prakt. Arzt, 1935, n. F., 20: 227; 255.—Falls, F. H. Use of hormones in obstetrics. Proc Interst. Postgrad. M. Ass. N. America, 1939, 72-5.— Foss, G. L. Clinical application of sex hormones. Clin. M. & S., 1939, 46: 497.—Frank, R. T. Hormone therapy in women. Med. Chn. N. America, 1941, 25: 607-13.—Geller, F. C. Die Hormontherapie in der Gynakologie. Ther. Ge- genwart, 1934, 75: 121-6.—Hanke, H. Hormone und Chi- rurgie. Deut. med. Wschr., 1938,64: 1617; 1653.—Hartley, E. C. Hormonal effects in women. Minnesota M., 1936, 19: 357-61.—Harvier, P. Regulations hormonales; conclusions pratiques en thdrapeutique. In Regul. hormon., Par., 1937, 843-8.—Hauptstein, P. Experimentelle und klinische Studien zur Hormonwirkung in der Gynakologie. Munch, med. Wschr., 1930, 77: 1223-5.—Heimann, F. Die Hormontherapie in der Gynakologie und Geburtshilfe. Prakt. Arzt, 1927, n. F., 12: 477; 503. Also Rev. med. Hamburgo, 1928, 9: 39-43. Also Tungchi med. Mschr., 1928-29, 4: 105; 134 — Helmholz, H. F. The hormones in practical pediatrics. Col- lect. Papers Mayo Clin., 1934, 26: 1095-7.—Hone, K. Appli- cation of the hormones in surgical diseases. J. Orient. M., Dairen, 1932, 16: 28.-—Kermauner, F. Hormonbehandlung in Geburtshilfe und Gynakologie. Aerztl. Prax., Wien, 1931, 5:289-93. Also Wien. klin. Wschr., 1931,44:1153-7.—Koch, W. Hormone und Hormontherapie in der Tiermedizin. Berl. tierarztl. Wschr., 1941, 177-82.—Kohler, R. Hormontherapie bei Blutungsanomalien. Zbl. Gyn., 1931, 55: 415-28 — Koenig, R. Dix ans d'hormonotherapie en gyn^cologie. Rev. med. Suisse rom., 1941, 61: 186.—Kraemer, R. Ueber die Verwendbarkeit eines neuen Hormonpraparats in der psy- chiatrischen Praxis. Psychiat. neur. Wschr., 1935, 37: 40-2.— Ktilbs, F. Hormonpraparate als Ersatz fehlender Organ- hormone. Med. Klin., BerL, 1933, 29: 141-3.—Laczka, S. [Paradoxical hormone therapy in gynecology] Gy6gyaszat, 1939, 79: 320-4.—MacLeod, D. 'Hormone therapy in gynae- cological conditions. J. Obst. Gyn. Brit. Empire, 1939, 46: 15-24.—Mansfeld. O. [Use of sexvjal and gonadotropic hor- mones in gynecology] Gyogyaszat, 1938, 78: 49; 78.—Mauriac, P. Les regulations hormonales en clinique medicale. In Regul. hormon.. Par., 1937, 24—9.—Mouriquand, G. Hormones et vitamines en clinique. Ibid., 802-11.—Neumann, H. O. El uso terapeutico de las hormonas del ovario y de las hor- monas gonadotropas del 16bulo anterior de la hipofisis. Rev. mid. germ. iber. amer., 1936, 9: 193-204.—Pignot, J. Con- siderations g£n£rales sur les hormones; quelques applications cliniques et therapeutiques. J. med. chir., Par., 1937, 108: 309-27.—Recasens Girol, S. La homoorganoterapia en el tratamiento de algunas ginecopatias. Progr. clin., Madr., 1913, 2: 40-5.—ReiflTerscheid, W. Die paradoxe Hormon- therapie in der Gynakologie. Zbl. Gyn., 1941, 65: 420-9 — Robson, J. M. Clinical applications. In his Recent Advances Sex, 2. ed., Phila., 1940, 278-319.—Simpson, S. L. Some indications for hormone therapy, and its rationale. Postgrad. M. J., Lond., 1937, 13: 405-12.—Sommer, K. Therapeutische Mitteilung zum klinischen Bild der hormonalen Unterfunktion. Med. Klin., Berl., 1939, 35: 1537.—Stockl, E. [Indications for rational hormontherapy in gynecology] Med. prakt., Poznan, 1936, 10: 192-8.—Van Kersschaever & De Mol, C. R. Les hormones et la bouche. J. dent, beige, 1938, 29: 356-64.— Veil, W. H. Hormone und innere Medizin. Aerztl. Rdsch., 1929, 39: 371; 385.—Vogt, E. Anzeigen der Hormonbehand- lung in der Frauenheilkunde. Ibid., 1936, 46: 85-90.— Wiegels, W. Hormonspiegel und gynakologische Hormon- therapie. Zbl. Gyn., 1932, 56: 2409.—Witzigmann, J. Die Hormontherapie in der Veterinarmedizin. Miinch. tierarztl. Wschr., 1936, 87: 541-6— Zacherl, H., & Tapfer, S. Die Hormontherapie in der Gynakologie und ihre Grundlagen. Wien. klin. Wschr., 1936, 49: 11-5—Zagari, G. Perparati ormonici di ^organi di muscoli nella terapia di disturbi circo- latori. Rass. internaz. clin. ter., 1932, 13: 543-5. --- Result. Eder, R. Erfahrungen mit der Hormonsalbe Akrotherm. Deut. Militararzt, 1938, 3: 427-9—Engelhart, E., & Zacherl, H. Klinisch-therapeutische Ergebnisse auf Grund neuerer Hormonforschungen. Wien. klin. Wschr., 1937, 50: »05-7.— Hajos, K. [Critics of endocrine treatment] Orvoskepzes, 1932, 22: 549-58.—Handovsky. H. Bemerkungen zur Hormon- therapie. Deut. med. Wschr., 1926, 52: 823 -Hendon, J. R. An evaluation of the present status of male hormone therapy. Kentucky M. J., 1941, 39: 176-84 —Hoffman. M. The present status of hormone therapy. South. M. & S., 1942 104: 79.— Hormone bank treatment gives miraculous results. Science News Lett., 1940, 38: 39.—Janssen, S. Kritik der Hormon- therapie. Med. Welt, 1939, 13: 109; 146.—Jores A. Was leistet die Hormontherapie heute? Vertrauensarzt, 1969, 7. 178-80.—Kemper, C. F. Comments upon some clinical uses ol hormones. Colorado M., 1935, 32: 463-5.—Saidl. J. Unsere Erfahrungen mit der Hormonaltherapie Handel. Internat. congr. verlosk., 1938, 7. Congr., 2: 499-502 Also Zbl. Gyn 1938, 62: 1731.—Tholen, M. H. G. A., & Schraflordt Koops [Certain experiences with hormone implant tabletsj JNea. tschr. geneesk., 1940, 84: 2440-2. ---- Untoward effect. Bauer J. Errors and dangers of hormone therapy. Ars medici, Basel, 1939 17: 3-8.-Fiessinger, N. Les abus en hormonotherapie. J. prat., Par., 1938, 52: bis, 772-5 — Laignel-Lavastine & Justin-Besancon. Les accidents de'la therapeutique hormonale et leur prevention. Bull. Soc. med. hop Pans, 1940-41, 56: 761-3.-Leoni Iparraguirre, C. A. L., & Bias Proto Dermitis gangrenosa de Nicolau debida a una '1'e?mCC.1Sno0eoh?rm?na en excipiente oleoso. Dia med., B. Air., r • i f»2-4—Liss, E. Social and asocial accompaniments ot intense hormone medication. N. York State J. M., 1939, 39: 8'f~?erio> F: Sugli effetti di una somministrazione prolun- S dl„orn)°"1 iPerglicemizzanti. Boll. Soc. ital. biol. sper., ■t 7- j ,~Yokoo> M- Experimentelle Untersuchung uber die durch wieclerholte Hormoninjektionen veranlassten 1929Wa29-U7^cm. Wurzb., R. Mayr, 1938. HORN, Erwin, 1904- ♦Ueber, histologische Veranderungen in Organen und Geschwulsten nach Rontgenbestrahlung [Munchen] 78p. 8? Miihlacker, C. Elser, 1928. ---- ♦Studien iiber die Einwirkung von Kronenringen auf das marginale Parodontium [Tubingen] p.1383-401. 8? Berl., J. Springer, 1930. Also Deut. Mschr. Zahnh., 1930, 48: HORN, Frank I., 1870- See Luckett, William H., & Horn, Frank I. Paraffin in surgery. 118p. 8? N. Y., 1907. HORN, Fritz [Franz Erich Rudolf] 1911- *Der Erfolg der Operation bei Bauchnarben- bruchen. 23p. 8? [Greifsw., n. pub.] 1935. HORN, H. Der menschliche Korper; ed. with visible vocabulary and notes bv Erwin T. Mohme. iii [3] 89p. 16>^cm. Bost., D. C. Heath & co. [1938] HORN 7SS HORN HORN, Henry. The perfect and complete l>el-man. [32] 1. 12? London, Will. Holcman, lr.cii. HORN, Johannes [Paul Michael] 1903- ♦Xormale und pathologische Lange des Darines einschliesslich der Doppelbildungen [Breslaul 2:{]>. S? Beuthen [n. pub.] 1931. HORN. John, 1856-1938. Obituary. Tr. Am. Lar. Rhin. Otol. Soc, 1939, 45: 476. HORN, Karl, 190S- ♦Querschlager- Schussverletzungen und ihre gerichtsarztliche Bedeutung [Minister] 19p. 8? Diisseld., G. H. Nolte, 1934. HORN, Kurt [Wilhelmi 190..- * Ver- gleichende Lntersuchungen iiber die Knochen- struktur zwischen dem Bockhufbein und dem normalen Hufbein. 45p. 2 pl. 8? Lpz. [n. pub.] 1931. HORN, Leo, 1902- *Zur Kasuistik der Aneurvsmen der Pulmonalarterie [Berlin] 9p. pl. 86 Dresd.. T. Steinkopff, 1929. Also Zsclir. K'n islaufforsch., 1929,21: HORN, Leonhard, 1908- *Ueber den Gehalt des Gehirns an Amylase. 15p. 8? Wiirzb., Gebr. Memminger, 1934. HORN. Luise Lotte, 1907- ♦Ein Beitrag zur Aetiologie des Wochenbettfiebers. p.43 53. 8? Bresl. [n. pub.] 1933. Also Mschr. Geburtsh. Gyn., 1933, 95: HORN, Oscar. ♦Histologiske studier over den menneskelige uterus med s;crlig henblik paa patogencsen af ruptura uteri. 154p. 8? Kbh. [n. pub.] 1916. HORN, Paul, 1863- Praktische Unfall- und Invalidenbegutachtung. 3. Aufl. xi, 321p. 8? Berl., J. Springer, 1932. HORN, Rudolf, 1908- ♦Ueber die Be- deutung zahnarztlicher SachverstandigentatiK- keit auf kriminalistischem Gebiete. p.147 76. S? [Bonn, n. pub., 1931] Also Arch. Krim., 1931, 88: HORN, Rudiger, 1896- ♦Ueber die Ruptur der Dermoide [Berlin] 39p. 8? Charlottenb., Gebr. Hoffmann [1934] HORN, Ruthardt, 1912- ^Statistisches und Biologisches von 216 aus eugenischen Griinden sterilisierten Frauen. 19p. ch. 20^cm Konigsb., .1. Raabe, 1936. HORN, W. O. von. Hualma, the Peruvian; the story of the discovery of quinine; transl. from the German. 90p. pl. 12? X. Y., E. Kaufmann [1890?] HORN, Walter, 1912- *Der bakterio- logische Test als diagnostisches Hilfsmittel bei der Amputation der Pulpa. 25p. 8? Bresl., K. Klossok, 1938. HORN, Walter Gotthard, 1905- ♦Die Teutsche Akademie der Chirurgie in Wurzburg (ein Plan von J. B. von Siebold um 1805) [Wiirz- burg] 28p. 8? Berl., J. Springer, 1932. Also Deut. Zschr. Chir., 1932, 236: HORN, Walter Louis, 1891-1938. (ilohus. J. H. Obituary. J. Mount Sinai Hosp. N. York, I!i3.s-;i'.i. 5: 709—Obituary. Tr. Am. Acad. Ophth. Otolar., 1939, 416. HORN. See also Cattle; Cornu cutaneum; Skin, Ap- pendages. Fambach, R. ♦Die Ringbildung an den Hornern der Cavicornier [Basel] 30p. 8? Jena, 1898. Frischmuth, G. [L. C.] ♦Untersuchungen iiber das Vorkommen und die klinische Bedeutung des Os cornu [Leipzig] 31p. 8? Jena, 1931. Maass [().] H. ♦Untrrsuchungen iiber die Moglichkeit des koinplikationslosen Kiir/.cns der Horner des Rindes. 38p. S? Kngelsd.-Lpz., 193 I. Schmidt, R. ♦Analoniischc und histolouisclie Lntersuchungen iiber den Bau und die Ursachen des Homes beim Perlhuhn (Numida ineleagris) [Bornl 36p. 8? Hannov.. 1910. Atzkern, J. Zur Entwicklung des Os cornu der Cavicornier. Anat. Anz., Jena, 1923-24, 57: 125-30.--Brandt. A. Ueber Horner und Geweihe. In 1 cstschr. 70. Geburt st. Rudolf Leuckarts, Lpz., 1892. 407-13—Brandt, K. Die Knt wickhmK des Homes beim Rinde bis zum Boginn der I'lieiunatisation des Hornzapfens; Beitrag zum Bau und zur Kntuiekluug von Hautorganen bei Saugotieren. Morph. Jahrb., 192S, 60: 128-68. -Burggraaf, H. [Cancer at the base of (he horns in zebus; horn-core disease of cattle] Tschr. diergeneesk., 1935, 02: 1121-36.- Castle, W. K. Genetics of horns in sheep. J. Hered.. 1940, .11 : 480. Champy, ('.. Kritch, N., & blombart. A. De quelques details reniarquaUes de hi structure des comes osseuses. C. rend. Soe. biol., 1929. 101: 784-8. Cox. F. O. Dehorning the milk cow. Vet. Med., Chic. 1931, 29: 294 — Desaintmartin. Fracture d'une come chez un boeuf, tumeur consecutive. Bull. Soc. sc. vet. Lvon, 1900, 3: 12-4.—Dove, W. F. The physiology of horn growth: a study of the morpho- genesis, the interaction of tissues, and the evolutionary processes of a Mendelian recessive character by means of transplantation of tissues. J. Exp. Zool., 1935. 69: 347; 405, 5 pl.----- Artificial production of the fabulous unicorn; a modern inter- lueiaii......f an ancient myth. Sc. Month.. 1936, 42: 431-6.- Drahn. V. Die Krweichungdes Homes fiir histologische Zwecka. Beil. Lie. m/iI. Wsehr., 1927, 43: 217-22, pi. Duerst, J. U. Kin Naehn.ig zu Aetiomorphose und Ontogencse der Ih'.jner der Cavieornia nach neuen Beobachtungen beim Hausrinde. Schweiz. Arch. Tierh., 1941, 83: 52-61.—Frank, E. R. k Roderick, I.. M. Squamous cell carcinoma of the bovine horn. J. Am. Vet. M. Ass., 1941, 99: 131.—Goubaux, A. Note sur la chute, la disunion et la formation nouvelle des comes fron- tales chez hs animaux de l'espece bovine. J. m<;d. vit., Lyon, 1805, 21: 413-24.—Grace-Calvert. Sur le traitement de la come de hufllo. J. chim. m£d., Par., 1865, 5. sir., 1: 229.—Ibsen. H. b., <>!> l.:ik- tcriellen Impfstoffcn. Berl. tieriirztl. Wschr., 1941, lo.'l. Griinert. Remonte-Lahmheiten. Zschr. Veteriniirk., 1928, 40: 405-13.—Habersang. Die Bedeutung der Kopfiicrveiisyrn- ptome fiir die Diagnostik der (lehii nei krankutigen beim l'ferde 'Berlv tieriirztl. Wschr., 1927, 43: 530-5.- Hahn, T. Beil rag zur Technik der diagnostischen Injektionen bei den I.alim- heiten der Pferde. Deut. tieriirztl. Wschr., 1930, .'18: 05 9. - Heuven, G. J. van [Sauarthrit injections in chronic lameness of horses] Tschr. diergeneesk., 192S, 55: 764-7.— Kerkeisen. Beitriigc zur Frage der Sanart hi itanwendung. Z.schr. \Cteii- narlc, 1928, 40: Ml 8. -Lameness; aids in its diagnosis Vet. Bull., Wash., 1932, 26: 30 50. Lcpinay, L. Traumatismo psychique chez un cheval. liev. path, comp., Par., 1915, 15: 415.—Lerena, C. A. Las claudicaciones en nuestros caballox de carrera. Rev. zoolecn., B. Ait.. 1920, 13: 171; 1929, 16: 360.—Perryman. W. Some nervous diseases alTecting the hind quarters of (lie horse. Vet. Bee, Lond., 19:12, 12: 573 82. - Priebus. Fine eigenartigc Ilullaliinlieit. Zsclir. Veteriniirk., 1933, 45: 301 73.—Rural, R. [Knzootic pnraplegv in horses'; a serotherapeutic experiment) Yoj. zdrav. listy, 1928, 4: 37- 9.—Saxinger, G. Impfungen negeii und bei Fohleiiliihme mit Pyosepticum viscosum-Streptokokkon-ImpfstolTcn. Deut tierarztl. Wschr., 1931, 39: 322-4.—Schmidt, J. Die kombi- nierte Schweif-Sphinktereii-biiliniiing des Pferdes. Zschr Infektkr. Haustiere, 1928, 33: 117-28, 4 pl.—Unilateral tenotomy for relief of springhalt. North Am. Vet., 1935, 16: No. 2, 18.—Wagner, F. Weiteier Beitrag zur Sanart'hrit- Therapie. Munch, tierarztl. Wsehr., 1930, 81: 173.—Widmann. Fohlenlahme. Ibid., 1937, 88: 79. ---- Disease: Pathology. Kern, J. *T*eber die narbigen Veranderungen am Schweifc ties Pferdes nach dem Kupicren (Auszug) [Leipzig] 8p. 8? [Bautzen] 1920. Pires, A. Contribucion al estudio de las fistulas adquiiidas o palologicas, a lesi6n piogena profunda, en los equinos. 44p. 261^cm. B. Air. 1940. Prevost, L. H. Contribution k l'etude des alterations cardio-vasculaires d'origine alimen- taire [Alfort] 42p. 8? Par., 1926. Racic, J. *Zur Kenntnis der Cholesteatome des Pferdes [Bern] 31p. 8? Virovitica, 1921. Zenglein, G. *Les variations pathologiques de la bilirubinemie chez le cheval [Alfort] 84p. 8? Strasb., 1930. Adrian. Observation sur un cas de fievre bilieuse hdma- turique avec hemorragie broiudio-pulmonaire, embolus et abces mdtastatiques sous-meniiiges; mort; autopsie. BuU. Soc. sc. vit., Lyon, 1900, 3: 51--6.—Akker, S. van den [Cholesteatoma as cause of blind staggers in a horse] Tschr. diergeneesk., 1936, 63: 597.—Barnard, W. G. Ossification in the left diaphrag- matic crus of a horse. Vet. J., Lond., 1929, 85: 355-9 — Burger, U. Das Blutbild moribunder Pferde. Arch. wiss. prakt. Tierh., 1928, 58: 54-67, pl— Buffagni, V. Di un caso di localizzazione atipica dcll'adenite equina alia regione della nuca. Clin, vet., Milano, 1935, 58: 782-7.—Carpenter. Les prelevements de produits pathologiques chez le cheval. Rec. mdd. vet., 1934,110:476-84.—Cesari, E. Quelquesremarquesau sujet du cancer chez le cheval. Bull. Soc. centr. med. vet., Par., 1922, 75: 171-6.------L'dpreuve de la sedimentation du sang chez le cheval. Bee. med. vet., 1929, 105: 621-4 — De Lan«e, M., & Belonje, C. W. A. Anatomical studies; local thickening of the vascular system in a horse. Onderstepoort J. Vet. Sc, 1935, 4: 571.—Didier, L. De certaines affections du cheval, connues par les indigenes du Senegal sous le nom de Toy, et comment ils les traitent. Rec. med. vit. exot., 1932, 5: 15-20.—Dremjatsky, Posrednik [et al.] Der Blutzustand bei gesunden und kranken Pferden. Arch. wiss. prakt. Tierh., 1929 60: 330-40.—Errington, B. J. Equine ophthalmology. Vet. Med., Chic, 1942, 37: 16.—Fournier, E. P. Blastemas en la especie equina. Rev. med. vet., B. Air., 1940, 22: 139; 181.—Graham, R. Direct isolation of pasteurella-like micro- organisms from brains of horses suffering from so-called corn- stalk disease. Science, 1935, 81: 387. Hennichs, B. I). Eine radiographische und pathologisch-histologische Studie uber Spat beim Pferde. Arch. wiss. prakt. Tierh. 1928, 58: 574- 003.—Hornung & Torgut, M. Blutdruckmessungen bei kranken Pferden mit dem Tonoszilhx'raph nach Plesch Ibid., 1930, 61: 105-13.—Innes, J. R. M., A: Whittick, J. W. Thrombo-angiitis obliterans in a horse. .1. I'aih. Bact., Lond., 1940, 50: 377-81, pl.—L'Hostis. Syndrome hdmorragique chez le cheval. Rec. mid. vit., 1931, 107: 1062.—Mamet. Effort des perfores posterieurs. Ibid., 1920, 102: 596.— Mizelle, J. D., & Graham, R. Studies on so-caUed cornstalk HORSE 793 HORSE disease in horses; feeding experiments. Cornell Vet., 1937, 27: 374-80.—Mohri, R. W. Sitfasts. Vet. Bull., Wash., 1937, 31: 202-7.—Padron, A., Castanedo, J. A., & Naranjo, J. Angina carbuncosa de los cquidos. Rev. med. cir. Habana, 1935, 40: 408-15.—Palat. Mdmoire sur la position de la courbe chez le cheval. Bull. Soc. centr. mdd. vdt., Par., 1877, 31:80-3.—Papp, G. Petechial diseases in thehorse] AUatorv. lap.,1 937, 60: 309.— Pasqualetti, A. Un caso congenito di cistolite e di fistole bila- terali auricolari nei cavallo. Profilassi, 1933, 6: 307.—Prudil, H. Adenitis equorum specifica, ein kasuistischer und therapeuti- scher Beitrag. Prag. Arch. Tiermed., 1933, 13: 97-9.— Roffo, A. H. El cancer en el caballo. Bol. Inst. med. exp cdncer, B. Air., 1924-25, 1: 694-702. Also repr—Riischer, W., & Sonntag, M. Ueber den Blutdruck bei iiber 39 Grad fie- bernden Pferden; vorlaufige Mitteilung. Arch. wiss. prakt. Tierh., 1930, 62: 508; 1932, 65: 1.—Scott, F. C. Recumbency in horses and cattle. Vet. Rec, Lond., 1933, 13: 169-71.— Volker. Die Senkungsgeschwindigkeit der roten Blutkorper- chen als Diagnostikum bei Pferdekrankheiten. Arch, wiss prakt. Tierh., 1924, 51: 15-23.—Weischer. Inguinal-sub- peritoneale Abszesse und Scheinzvstcn beim Pferde. Deut tierarztl. Wschr., 1935, 43: 695. ---- Disease: Prevention. Bernhardt. Erfolgreiche Bekampfung der Unfruchtbarkeit, des Verfohlens der Stuten und der Fohlcnkrankheiten. Deut. tierarztl. Wschr., 1926, 34: 107-9.—Miguelote Vianna, M., & Carneiro Vianna, L. Notas sobre prophvlaxia e tratamento do garrotilho. Arch. Inst. Vital Brazil, 1926-27, 4: 113-22.— Uveis Maskar [Importance of the Instanbul control data of treatments and results in diseases of horses] Askeri vet. mecmuasi, 1939, 16: 201-28. ---- Disease, respiratory. Bergmann, H. F. *Die Briisseler-Krankheit des Pferdes im Urteil der Deutschen Tier- medizin. 40p. 8? Engelsdorf-Lpz., 1933. Guyon, C. A. A. *Le cornage chronique chez le cheval et son traitement chirurgical par l'op6ration do Williams [Alfort] 28p. 8? Orleans, 192S. Sorriatj, P. L. E. *Le traitement chirurgical du cornage [Alfort] 48p. 8? Par., 1928. Adams, J. W. Roaring in horses. Rep. Vet. Med. Iowa CoU. Agr., 1917, 2: 220-33.—Arnold, T. F. Relationship of vaso-motor mechanism to certain equine unsoundnesses. J. R. Army Vet. Corps, 1939, 10: 100-18.—Basset, J., & Moulin, A. Epizootie de colibacillose d'origine vermineuse et role pathogene des strongles des dquidds. C. rend. Soc. biol., 1930, 104: 996-8.—Burger, U. Ueber die Wirkung des Atro- pins bei der Dampfigkeit der Pferde. Arch. wiss. prakt. Tierh., 1926, 54: 427-61.—Cadeac. Sur la gudrison spontande du cornage chronique. Bull. Soc. sc. vdt. Lyon, 1901, 4: 250-2. — Clarenburg, A., & van Heelsbergen, T. [Pavement cell carcinoma of the nostril and throat in a horse] Versl. volksge- zondh., 1932, 958, pl.—Eckert. Erfahrungen iiber die Opera- tion von Kehlkopfpfeifern. Zschr. Veterinark., 1928, 40: 33-51.—Fontaine. Roaring in horses; summary of report. Rep. Internat. Vet. Congr. (1914) 1915, 10. Congr., 3: 702-4 — Gornemann, W. Kehldeckelmissbildung als Ursache exspira- torischen Kehlkopfpfeifens. Deut. tierarztl. Wschr., 1939, 47: 38.—Hilgendorff. Kehlkopfpfeifen als Hauptmangcl. Zschr. Veterinark., 1927, 39: 224-31.—Hobday, F. The surgical treatment of roaring in horses. Rep. Internat. Vet. Congr. (1914) 1915, 10: Congr., 3: 708-14. Also North Am. Vet., 1936, 17: No. 4, 17-21.—Horn, H. Airosanainhalationstherapie katarrhalisch-eitriger Erkrankungen der Atmungsorgane beim Pferd. Berl. tierarztl. Wschr., 1933, 49: 503-5.—Kaka, A. G. A case of roaring. Ind. Vet. J., 1940, 16: 417.—Kladek, V. [Enzootic paraparesis in the horse due to infectious catarrh of the upper respiratory tract] Voj. zdrav. listy, 1928, 4: 263-7.— Kraft. Die Behandlung von influenzaartigen Erkrankungen des Pferdes mit intravenosen Infusionen von Chinosol. Deut. tierarztl. Wschr., 1929, 37: 358.—Krallert, L. Inhalations- therapie bei Erkrankungen der Atmungswege mit Tussex- Raucherkerzen. Wien. tierarztl. Mschr., 1928, 15: 265.— Lawrence, C. J. R. Equine nasal catarrh and its treatment by vaccines. Vet, Rec, Lond., 1923, 3: 811.—Martens, O. Therapeutische Versuche mit Kupfersalvarsan (K3 Ehrlich) und Kupfersalvarsannatrium bei der Brustseuche der Pferde. Deut. tierarztl. Wschr., 1925, 33: 450-2.—Mitchell, W. M. A general consideration of the unsoundness problem in the horse. Vet. Rec, Lond., 1931, 11: 1126-30.—Mori, N. Esperi- menti di isopatinoterapia deH'irifluenza toracica del cavallo. Profilassi, 1931, 4: 139.—Nocard. Le cornage chronique et sa transmission hdrdditaire. Bull. Soc centr. mdd. vdt.. Par., 1899, 53: 54-61.—Operation (An) forroaring. Vet. Rec, Lond., 1934, 14: 980-3.—Repiquet. Opdration sur la cloison mddiane du nez d'un cheval corneur par une fenetre sur le chanfrein. BuU. Soc. sc. vdt, Lyon, 1901, 4: 252.—Schiiper, W. Ueber die Erblichkeit des Kehlkopfpfeifens beim Pferd. Deut. tierarztl. Wschr., 1939, 47: 385-8.—Schurmann, E. Pathologische Organbefunde beim sogenannten Hoppegartener Husten. Berl. tierarztl. Wschr., 1933, 49: 161-4.—Sigler, T. A. Opera- tion for the relief of roaring. Vet. Med., Chic, 1938, 33: m^w .?• • Kr112t}sc}e Betrachtungen zur Diagnostik der Dampfigkeit beim.Pferde. Berl. tierarztl. Wschr., 1936, 52: tL6 1 agg J T he nerve grafting operation for roaring. Vet J., Lond 1935, 91: 396-8.—Tscherniak, W. S. Zur Lehre von den Broncho- und Pneumonomvkosen der Pferde Arch wiss. prakt. Tierh., 1927-28, 57: 417-44. ------ 'Cursch^ mannsche Spiralen in den Lungen von Pferden. Berl. tierarztl. Vv schr., 1928, 44: 399-403.—Vermeulen, H. A. New researches 7m* ,r£arJ"g m horses- Rep. Internat. Vet. Congr. (1914) 1915, 10 Congr., 3: 717-20.—Waldmann, O., & Kobe, K Der seuchenhafte Husten des Pferdes (Hoppegartener Husten) Berl tierarztl. Wschr., 1934, 50: 561-4. ------ Epizootic cough in horses: equine infectious bronchitis. Vet Rec Lond. 1936, 16: 80-7.------& Pape, J. Vorlaufige Mittei- lung uber die Aetiologie des Hoppegartener Hustons der Pferde Berl. tierarztl. Wschr., 1934, 50: 1-3.—Williams, W. L., & Frost, J. N. The technique of the operation for roaring. Rep. Internat. Vet. Congr. (1914) 1915, 10. Congr., 3: 681-91.— Wilson, T. Examination of the unsound horse; the significance of certain defects and ailments which constitute unsoundness Vet. Rec, Lond., 1935, 15: 1369-76. ---- Disease, skeletal. Akerblom, E. *Ueber die Aetiologie und Pathogenese der Futterrehe beim Pferde [Stock- holm] 168p. 8? Berl., 1934. Detjckels; F. H. *TJeber Bursitis intertuber- cularis. 18p. 8? Giessen, 1928. Duchosal, F. *Le keraphyllocele du pied du cheval [Univ. Berne] 39p. 8? Lyon, 1909. Hock, F. *Die Kastanie der Equiden; ihre Entwicklung, ihre Struktur, ihr Wert zur Rasse- und Exterieurbeurteilung und die wahrschein- liche Ursache ihres Vorhandenseins [Bern] 52p. 8? Bad Kissingen, 1910. Hossein, C. Contribution k l'etude clinique du mal de garrot chez le cheval [Alfort] 76p. S° Par., 1932. Pierrot, E. Contribution a l'etude des ossifirations des aponeuroses chez le cheval (osteomes de l'aponevrose fessiere) 40p. 8? Par., 1927. Ackert, J. E., & O'Neal, W. S. Parasitism and fistulous withers. J. Am. Vet. M. Ass., 1930, 77: 28-36.—Adams, J. W. Diseases of the foot. Rep. Vet. Med. Iowa Coll. Agr., 1917, 2: 234—59.—Akiyama, S. On a case of so-called "Sunefuto- disease" or milk leg of the horse. Tr. Jap. Path. Soc, 1927, 17: 231-4.—Antonini, A. Sullo spostamento della terza falange nella podoflemmatite cronica degli equini. Clin. vet. Milano, 1929, 52: 352-5.—Baird, J. C. A case of fistulous withers treated by Brucella abortus vaccine. Vet. J., Lond., 1937, 93: 142.—Bemis, H. E. Diseases of the head of the horse. Rep. Vet. Med. Iowa Coll. Agr., 1916, 1: 157-80. ------ Fistula of the withers in horses. Vet, Pract. Bull. Iowa Coll. Agr., 1925, 8: 51-63, 3 pl.—Bossi, V. Sul significato dei cheraceli stelidioidi sottoparietali del cavallo. Clin, vet., Milano, 1931, 54: 496- 507, 4 pl.—Campbell, D. M. Skeletal disease of the horse. Vet. Bull., Wash., 1937, 31: 40-58.—Cinotti, F. Delia navicolite cronica negli equini. Clin, vet,, Milano, 1939, 62: 519-43.— Cocu. Rapport: Traitement du vessigon tendineux tarsien du cheval par les injections de teinture d'iode par M. Daniel Bourbon. Bull. Soc. centr. mdd. vdt., Par., 1926, 79: 200-2.— Corneliussen, B. D. [Case of windgall in the extensor tendon sheath of the fore-leg] Medded. Haerens Heste, 1934, 28: 24.—Donahue, M. Navicular disease in horses. Vet. Med., Chic, 1935, 30: 244-6.—Dykstra, R. R. Ringbone of horses. North Am. Vet., 1922, 3: 612; 625.—Fernandez, E. Las osteo- artropatfas en los equideos. Mem. Congr. mdd. nac mex., 1910, 4. Congr., 867-81.—Fitch, C. P., Bishop, L., & Boyd, W. L. Report of further work on the relation of Bact. abortus Bang to fistula and poll-evil of horses. J. Am. Vet. M. Ass., 1932, 80: 69-79.—Forsell, G. Eine neue Technik fiir die Schnittlegung bei der Operation der Widerristfistel. Deut. tierarztl. Wschr., 1924, 32: 117.—Fowler, G. R. Diseases of the foot of the horse. Vet. Med., Chic, 1938, 33: 216-21.—Frank, E. R. Fistula of the withers. North Am. Vet., 1935, 16: No. 5, 16-9. Also Vet. Pract., Evanston, 1936, 17: 8-16.—Gavard, G. Note clinique au sujet du traitement d'un vessigon tarsien. Bull. Soc. sc vdt. Lyon, 1902, 5: 221-4.—Greenlee, C. W. The skeletal diseases of horses and their relation to nutrition. Vet. Bull., Wash., 1940, 34: 248-58.—Guard, W. F. Fistula of the withers. North Am. Vet., 1932, 13: 19-23.—Hancek. Die Drusestatistik im Wandel der Geschichte des Veterinarwesens in den Remon- teamtern. Zschr. Veterinark., 1938, 50: 194-8.—Hartog. J. H. [PecuUar case of fistula of the rib in a horse; excision of rib] Tschr. diergeneesk., 1937, 64: 1282-4— Hutschenreiter, C. Die Impfung beim Pferde mit Cupal. Wien. tierarztl. Mschr., 1928, 15: 145-68.—Jones, V. B. The diagnosis of navicular disease. Vet. Rec, Lond., 1934, 14: 341.—Karasev, P. A., & Bulgakov, N. I. [Study of the so-called cracking joint of the horse] Sovet. vet., 1940, 17: No. 2, 89-92.—Lagaillarde. La mdthode dei a rosde dans la parure des pieds antdrieurs. Bull. HORSE Acad. vdt. France, 1934, 7: 336.—Lang. W. W. Navicular disease; an experiment in treatment. Vet. Rec, Lond., 1936, 16: 1431.—Lerena, C. A. Enfermedades mas frecuentes en los basos del caballo. Hev. zootdcn., B. Air., 1929, 16: 374-82.— Maly, N.. & Csernok. I'. [Aeropa< hia in horse] AUatorv. lap., 1933, 56: 290.—Mitchell, W. M. Rheumatic disease in the horse. Annual Rep. Brit. Nat. Com. Rheum., 1938, 4: 50-67.— Niven, A. Fistulous withers and poU-evil: successful treatment with bacterin. Vet. Rec, Lond., 1934, 14: 283.—OhI. Zwei F&lle von Genickbeule mit anschliessender Genickfistel. Zschr. Veterinark., 1928, 40: 173-85.—Oxspring, G. E. Navicular disease; a short review. J. R. Army Vet. Corps, 1934, 5: 66- 71. ------ The radiology of navicular disease, with observa- tions on its pathology. Vet. Rec, Lond., 1935, 15: 1433-46, 2 pl. ------ Ringbone probably associated with tuberculosis. Ibid., 1936, n. ser., 16: 707-9.-—Perrin, G. A new operative technique for fistula of the withers; treatment with lactic fer- ments. Vet. Med., Chic, 1939, 34: 484-6.—Pillers, A. W. N. The parasitic origin of poU evil and fistulous withers. Vet. Rec, Lond., 1931, 11: 1246.—Reinhardt, C. Zur Sanarthrit- Behandlung der Arthritis chronica deformans tarsi des Pferdes. Arch. wiss. prakt. Tierh., 1926, 54: 349-62.—Rodebaugh, H. D. Surgical treatment of chronic laminitis. Vet. Med.. Chic, 1938, 33: 288.—Scott, F. C. Treatment of fistulous withers and poll evil. Vet. Rec, Lond., 1932, 12: 1357.—Seelemann, M. Die Durchfiihrung der Galtbekampfung und -behandlung in der Praxis. Deut. tierarztl. Wschr., 1933, 41: 337-45.—Selmer, I. H., & Fritzb0ger, E. [Chronic tendon diseases (in horses)] Medded. Haerens Heste, 1934, 28: 21.—Steward, J. S. Fistu- lous withers and poll-evil: equine and bovine onchocerciasis compared, with an account of the life histories of the parasites concerned. Vet. Rec, Lond., 1935, 15: 1563-75, 4 pl.; 1936, 16: [Discussion] 175-81, 2 pl.—Wright, J. G. Split pastern in a pony. Ibid., 1933, 13: 136, pi.—Zimmermann, A., [Cancer of the hoof] AUatorv. lap., 1935, 58: 139. ---- Disease: Transmission to man. Barrier, A. Sur l'observation du Dr Crdpet relative k un cas de dermatose humaine subsdquente au crapaud du cheval. Rec. mdd. vet., 1911, 88: 258; 260.—Leipold, W. Eine Blasen- erkrankung der Hande und des mannlichen Gliedes, wahr- scheinlieh durch Pferdedruse vermittelt. Derm. Wschr., 1931, 93: 1533 40. Metaxa, L. Del cimorro de'cavalli comunicabile aU'uomo. Ann. med. chir., Roma, 1842, 7: 245; passim. ---- Disease: Treatment. Briicklmayer. Ueber die Wirkung von Pabozin bei der Behandlung von Mauke und von traumatisehen Gewebsdefek- ten. Miinch. tierarztl. Wschr., 1927, 78: 691.—Doenecke, H. Kleine Winke fiir schwere FaUe in der Pferdepraxis. Ibid., 1935, 86: 481-6.—Downs, E. A. The treatment of sit-fast in horses. North Am. Vet., 1935, 16: 26.—Georges. Traitement de l'anasarque par les injections intraveineuses de formol. Rev. vdt. mil., Par., 1931, 15: 487-90.—Groulade. La fluxion pdriodique traitde par un colorant azolque. Bull. Acad. vdt. France, 1937, 10: 285.—Hasitschka, L., & Molnar, A. Erfah- rungen mit der Nasenschlundsonde beim Pferde. Wien. tier- iirztl. Mschr., 1926, 13: 318-22.—Houze. Nouvelle mdthode de traitement de l'encastelure. Rec. mdd. vet., 1936, 112: 271-3.-—Kolda, J. [Certain diagnostic methods and treatment of horses in France] Zver. obzor, 1939, 32: 259-64.—Kriiger, R. Die Eignung der Neumann-Schultzschen Nasenschlund- sonde zum Eingeben fliissiger Arznei beim Pferde. Berl. tierarztl. Wschr., 1926, 42: 205-10.—Liiders. Neue Wege zur Behandlung des Morbus maculosus der Pferde mittels Hamo- dialthesan und Cejodyl nebst Bemerkungen iiber die Therapie hamorrhagischer Diathesen iiberhaupt. Ibid., 1930, 46: 81- 4.—Ram, C. Indigenous horse masalah, condition powder. Ind. Vet. J., 1940, 17: 83-6.—Schaack. Encore un mot sur l'emploi de l'acdtate bibasique de cuivre, verdet du commerce, dans le traitement du crapaud. J. mdd. vdt., Lyon, 1860, 16: 304-8.—Zagrodzki, C. Light therapy in the treatment of horses. Vet. J., Lond., 1930, 86: 163-70.—Zemke. Bericht uber Versuche mit AOI Bengen. Zschr. Veterinark., 1935, 47: 129-37. ---- Doping. Baars, G. Das Dopen der Rennpferde vom strafrechtlichen Standpunkt und die Beurteilung der iibeUchen Nachweis- methoden der Dopingalkaloide im Speichel der Pferde. Deut. tierarztl. Wschr., 1926, 34: 147-53.—B0je, O. [Doping] Nord. med., 1939, 2: 1963-71.—Drugging of race horses. In Traffic in Opium (U. S. Bur. Narcotics) Wash. (1940) 1941, 45.— Fitzgerald, T. C. Illegitimate use of drugs on race horses. Vet. Med., Chic, 1935, 30: 321.—Lorentz, F. H. Doping unter eugenischer Betrachtung. Arch, sozial. Hvg., 1933-34, 8: 311-4.—Lucas. G. H. W. The saliva test. Canad. J. Comp. M., 1939, 3: 67-72. Also J. R. Army Vet. Corps, 1939, 10: 164—9.— Munch, J. C. Saliva tests; detecting the adminis- tration of some opium derivatives to horses. J. Am. Pharm. Ass., 1935, 24: 557-60.—Neumann-Kleinpaul, K., &, Riischer, W. KUnische Untersuchungen gedopter Pferde. Arch. wiss. prakt. Tierh., 1931-32, 64: 226-34.— Rasp ail, F. V. L'art de dompter les chevaux les plus rebeUes, par J. S. Rarey. Rev. compl. sc. appl. mdd., Par., 1858-59, 5: 265-71—Sallis- bury, E. Method of obtaining saliva for the saUva test. Canad. J. Comp. M„ 1939, 3: 101.—Schick. Das Dopen der Pferde. HORSE Zschr. Veteriniirk., 1933, 45: 241-50.- Williams. G. A.. & Stone, E. C. Securing and testing saliva and urine samples for the detection of drugs used to stimulate race horses. Canad. J. Comp. M., 1941, 5: 243-6. ---- Draft horse. Deschamps, G. *Le cheval de trait du nord [Alfort] G2p. 8° Par., 1934. Frisson. M. (). *L'elevage du cheval de trait en Haute-Saone [Alfort] 72p. 8? Vesoul, 1931. Lecerf, A. J. *Kss:ii stir le travail et l'alimcn- tation du cheval de trait [Alfort] 91 p. S? Par., 1929. Porthan, A. *Untersuchungen iiber die Trabereigenschaften des finnischen Pferdes, unter besonderer Berucksichtigung der Mechanik der Extremitaten. 68p. 8? Lpz., 1931. Buhle, P. Das Kaltblutpferd als Zugpferd im Heer. Mil. Wbl., Berl., 1939-40, 124: 1495.—Edwards, G. V. J. Care and management of coUiery horses. Vet. Rec, Lond., 1931, 11: 1069-72.—Gareis, M. Dauerzugleistungsprufungen fiir Ober- lander- und Rottaler Warmblutpferde. Miinch. tierarztl. Wschr., 1937, 88: 25-7. ------ Das Obcrliinder Pferd in der Gelandezugleistungspriifung. Ibid., 613-5.—Gayot, E. De la production des chevaux de trait au trot. J. mdd. vdt., Lyon, 1853, 9: 331-5.—Guaita, F. de. Les chevaux d'agri- culture en Angleterre. Ibid., 1857, 13: 515-21.—Kruger, W. Die schwere Zugarbeit und ihre Auswirkungen auf die Sehnen der Vordergliedmasse des Pferdes. Deut. tierarztl. Wschr., 1941, 49: 203-8.—Kudriavtsev, A. A. [Physiology of the working horse] Tr. Inst. eksp. vet. med., Moskva, 1928, 5: 3-11.—Letard, E. Les dpreuves dynamomdtriques de traction; le pneu dans la traction animale. Rec. mdd. vdt., 1935, 91: 714-22.—McCunn, J. The selection of the commercial horse. Vet. Rec, Lond., 193 1. 14: 713-6.—Present (The) prospects of the commercial horse. Ibid., 1939, 51: 1285.—Revallo, V. [Study of the appearance of the heavy draft horse] Zver. obzor, 1940, 33: zvdr. rozpr., 56.—Sardinian horse as a pack animal. Vet. Bull., Wash., 1937, 31: 335-39. ---- Epizootic disease. Arrete du 7 ddcembre 1936; sur la nomenclature des maladies rdputdes contagieuses (dquidds) Bull. Min. san. pub., Par., 1936,261.—Delamotte, M. Epizooties del'Algdrie. BuU. Soc. centr. mdd. vdt., Par., 1881, 35: 195-229.—Eckert. Die in der Pferdeseuchenstation Berlin mit Strahlentherapie angestellten Versuche. Zschr. Veteriniirk., 1927, 39: 33-64.—Finzi. G. Sul catarro epizootico laringo-tracheale del cavallo. Ann. igiene sper., 1915, n. ser., 24: 655-71.—Goret, P., Vuillaume, P., & Lelandais, E. Prdparation d'un sdrum homologue spdeifique contre la maladie de Carrd. C. rend. Soc. biol., 1936, 122: 1283-6.—Gurwitsch, B. M., & Subotnik, A. S. Zum Studium der Beschiilseuche der Pferde und der Komple- mentbindungsreaktion als diagnostischer Methode. Zschr. Infektkr. Haustiere, 1932-33, 43: 169-84.—Kobe, K. Die Immunitat beim seuchenhaften Husten des Pferdes. Berl. tierarztl. Wschr., 1936, 52: 325.—Oppermann, T. Diagno- stische, therapeutische und forensische Gesichtspunkte bei heimischen Viruskrankheiten der Pferde. Deut. tier&rztl. Wschr., 1939, 47: 369-72.—Panisset, L. La prdvention des maladies infectieuses du cheval aux armdes. Rev. vdt. mil., Par., 1932, 16: 157.—Peatt, E. S. W. Contagious diseases of the horse under war-time conditions; with special reference to diagnosis and treatment. Vet. Rec, Lond., 1940, 52: 57-60.— Pillers, A. W. N. Remarks on the clinical aspects of contagious nasal catarrh in horses. Ibid., 1934, 14: 1153-60.—Pusch. Erfahrungen bei der Seuchenhygiene und Seuchenbekampfung in den Remonteamtern. Zschr. Veteriniirk., 1938, 50: 199- 205.—Rappin, G., Soubrane, L., & Szelely, L. Recherches sur la rdsistance des dquidds k l'infection bacillaire. C. rend. Soc. biol., 1928, 99: 1768.—Richters. Vergleichende Untersu- chungen chemischer Desinfektionsmittel in ihrer Bedeutung fiir Rotz, Druse, Milzbrand und ansteckende Blutarmut der Pferde. Zschr. Veterinark., 1927, 39: 401-27, pl., ch.—Richters, C. E. Brustseuche des Pferdes. In Handb. Viruskr. (E. Gildemeister, et al.) 1939, Jena, Bd 2, 115-21. ---- Equipment. Becker, E. Maulgatter fur Pferde nach Dr Becker-Dun, Sarstedt. Deut. tierarztl. Wschr., 1937, 45: 357.—Collier. Marcellange, dit colUer hygidnique. J. med. vdt., Lyon, 1849, 5: 202-7.—Habacher, F. Tierschutz durch richtige Bespan- nung und Sattelung; wie wird der Studierende in dieser Hinsicht fiir die Praxis ausgebildet? Wien. tieriirztl. Mschr., 1939, 26: 97-105.—Heane, C. W. Chinese slocks. J. R. Army Vet. Corps, 1941-42, 13: 21.—Jonquieres, H. A propos du collier antitiqueur Groslambert. Rev. vdt., Toulouse, 1920, 72: 666-70.—Klingemann. Betrachtungen tiber die Wirkung der Gebisszaumung. Zschr. Veterinark., 1930, 42: 470—4.— Knowles, R. H. The New Zealand or aU weather rug. J. R. Army Vet. Corps, 1940-41, 12: 112-6.—Nurettin Erdogn [Factors of harness which permit maximum pulling power of the horse] Askeri vet. mecmuasi, 1940, 18: No. 144, 2-13. HORSE 795 HORSE ---- Feeding and food. See also Fodder. Platos, D. *L'alimentation du cheval par les fourrages melassds [Alfort] 48p. 8? Par., 1934. Poncelet, J. *L'alimentation du cheval a l'avoine germee [Alfort] 52p. 8? Par., 1934. Balas, G. [Contemporary system of feeding army horses] AUatorv. lap., 1939, 62:167-9.—Bang, O. The mineral metab- olism in horses fed exclusively on bran. Aarsskr. Vet. Land- boh0jsk„ Kbh., 1925, 383-404.—Bemelmans, E. Dell'aU- mentazione degli animaU equini per mezzo dell'avena schiac- ciata. Gior. med. vet., 1928, 77: 707-20.—Brocq-Rousseu. Sur l'emploi, dans l'alimentation du cheval, des broussaiUes broydes et mdlassdes, de chdne Kermds et d'ajonc. Rev. vdt. mil., Par., 1926, 10: 279-96.—Bruder. Ueberblick uber Futtermittel, Fiitterung, Rationssatze und deren Beziehungen zu den Magendarmerkrankungen der Pferde in den neuzeit- lichen Heeren. Zschr. Veteriniirk., 1936, 48: 305-18.— Delorme. Etudes sur l'alimentation des solipddes. J. mdd. vdt., Lyon, 1859, 15: 520; 555.—Doan, W. H. Report on trial feeding of variation ration 1 and 2 (authorized by Par. 3d 2. ar. 30-480) Vet. Bull., Wash., 1928,21: Suppl., 253-8. — Fairbanks, B. W. Animal nutrition; vitamin A; occurrence in hay and silage; deficiency svmptoms; requirements of horse. North Am. Vet., 1940, 21: 281-3.—Frischbier. Die Haferverdauung des Pferdes im Lichte der mikroskopischen Kotuntersuchung. Zschr. Veterinark., 1933, 45: 1-12.—Goldfiem, J. S. de. Les ressources coloniales dans l'alimentation des chevaux mdtro- poUtains. Rev. mdd. vdt., Par., 1936, 112: 663-6.—Huvellier. De l'influence de la nourriture et des croisements sur l'espdce du cheval. Mdm. Soc nat. centr. mdd. vdt., Par., 1854, 2: 413- 54.—Jones, H. D. The economics of feeding the commercial horse. Vet. Rec, Lond., 1935, 15: 523-31.—Kintner, J. H. The calcium-phosphorus ratio in the ration of horses. J. R. Army Vet. Corps, 1940-41, 12: 101-11. Also Vet. Med., Chic, 1940, 35: 640-8.—Krantz, E. B., & Speelman, S. R. Nutrition of horses and mules. Yearb. U. S. Dep. Agr., 1939, 763-86 — Lavalard. Emploi de la mdlasse dans l'alimentation du cheval. Bull. Soc. centr. mdd. vdt., Par., 1902, 56: 189-202.— Lepi- nay, L. Economies k rdaliser sur la nourriture des chevaux. Rev. path, comp., Par., 1917, 17:170.-----Les aigues dans l'alimentation des chevaux. Ibid., 1919, 19: 71-5.—Lettre de M. Delorme k M. Magne sur l'alimentation des solipddes. J. mdd. vdt., Lyon, 1860, 16: 242; 308; 362—Liautard. La mdlasse comme nourriture dans l'armde des Etats-Unis en campagne k Porto-Rico. Bull. Soc. centr. mdd. vdt., Par., 1902, 56: 249-53.—Magne & Delorme. Etudes sur l'alimentation des solipddes. J. mdd. vdt.. Lyon, 1860, 16: 28; 82.—Miller, W. C, & Muir, W. B. The possibilities of artificially dried grass for feeding Army horses. J. R. Army Vet. Corps, 1940- 41, 12: 17-24.—Noonan, J. E. Rice hay. Vet. Bull., Wash., 1937, 31: 34-9.—Post, G. Emploi du filet pour la distribution du fourrage dans la cavalerie. Rev. path, comp., Par., 1915, 15: 410.—Rey, A. Essais faits k Lyon sur 1'aUmentation des chevaux avec l'avoine dcrasde et les fourrages hachds. J. mdd. vdt., Lyon, 1858, 14: 113-27.—Rozov, A. A. [Experimental feeding of horses with combined grain] Sovet. vet., 1939, 16: No. 10-11, 84-8.—Satre, A. Alimentation des chevaux d'une formation sanitaire pendant les 2 dernidres anndes de campagne; emploi de l'avoine germde. Rev. path, comp., Par., 1919, 19: 17-20. ------ Alimentation des chevaux d'une formation sanitaire pendant les dernidres anndes de la campagne; addition de l'ortie k la ration de fourrage. Ibid., 52.—Way, C. The importance of vitamin-mineral supplements in equine nutrition. J. Am. Vet. M. Ass., 1941, 99: 121-9.—Wilkinson, D. E. On turning out to grass. Vet. J., Lond., 1936, 92: 178-81. --- Foal [and its diseases] Devaux, A. J. *Rclations sur la mortalite et les affections specifiques des poulains nouveau- nes dans Le Perche [Alfort] 52p. 8? Par., 1926. Chaintre. Rupture du tendon extenseur antdrieur des phalanges sur un poulain. J. mdd. vdt., Lyon, 1857, 13: 16-20.—Ewen, L. C. Influence of supplemental feeding upon the weights of depot-raised foals. Vet. Bull., Carlisle, 1942 36: 1-12.—Gurwitsch, B. M. Die Pyosepticamie der Fohlen. Arch. wiss. prakt. Tierh., 1931, 63: 418-35— Hughes, H.. T. Common ailments of the foal from birth to weaning Vet. Rec, Lond., 1934, 14: 683-90.—Jennings, W. E. Equine abortion and diseases of foals. Vet. Bull., Carlisle, 1941, 35: 290-314.—Knoll, C. Rupture congdnitale du muscle extenseur antdrieur des phalanges sur les 2 membres d'un poulain J. mdd. vdt., Lyon, 1849, 5: 64-8.— Lang, W. W. Foal mortality; report for 1938. Vet. Rec, Lond., 1939, 51: 138-44—Mcin- tosh, R. A. Diseases of the newborn in the equine species. J. Am. Vet. M. Ass., 1941, 99: 209; 1942,100: 244—Mascherpa, A. Alcune osservazioni e ricerche sulle infezioni dei puledri neonati. CUn. vet., Milano, 1935, 58: 779-82—Miessner, H., & Koser, A. Fohlenkrankheiten. Deut. tierarztl. Wschr., 1935 43: 145-50—Peters, Orthopadie an den Extermitaten der Fohlen. Ibid., 1938, 46: 337; 357; 371.—Saraceno, S. Le infezioni neonatali nei puledri. CUn. vet., Milano, 1940, 63: 259-66.—Sheather, A. L. Fainting in foals. J. Comp. Path". Ther., Edinb., 1924, 37: 106-13.—UI6, F. [Certain common injuries in colts] Zver. obzor, 1939, 32: 117-9 — Voss, W Wichtiges zur Fohlenkrankheiten-Behandlung. Berl. tierarztl. Wschr., 1939, 55: 123. ---- Forensic aspect. Norr, J. Ueber bedingtes Auftreten von Koppen und Leineweben und seine forensische Bedeutung. Berl. tierarztl. Wschr., 1933, 49: 805-8—Vente d'un animal que le vendeur soupconna.it dtre atteint de tuberculose; dissimulation par le vendeur de sa vdritable identitd. Rev. vdt., Toulouse, 1923 75: 93—5. ---- Gelding. See Castration. ---- Growth and development. Crew, F. A. E., & Buchanan Smith, A. D. The genetics of the horse. Bibliogr. genet., Gravenh., 1930, 6: 123-70.— Crile, G., & Quiring, D. P. A comparison of the energy- releasing organs of the white whale, Delphinapterus leucas, and the thoroughbred horse Equipoise. Growth, Ithaca, 1940, 4: 291-8.—Matthew, W. D. The evolution of the horse; a record and its interpretation. Q. Rev. Biol., 1926, 1: 139-85.— Quiring, D. P. Growth in the thoroughbred horse. Anat. Rec, 1941, 79: Suppl., No. 2, 50. ---- History and folklore. Guillot, L. P. G. *La figure du cheval; essai d'iconographie hippique [Alfort] 220p. 8? Le Goupy, 1927. Here begynneth the proprytees and MEDYCYNES FOR hors [24]p. 22}£cm. [Lond., ca. 1525] Malbie, N. A plaine and easie way to remedy a horse that is foundered in his feete [8]p. 24cm. Lond., 1853. Prallet, L. *Le cheval dans la Grece antique. 63p. 25cm. Lyon, 1939. Bord, B. Le cheval blessd du tombeau de l'Empereur Tai Tsoung. Aesculape, Par., 1933, n. ser., 23: 22.—Centaure (Le) Chiron et le symbolisme du cheval. Ibid., 1929, n. ser., 19: No. 4.—Chard, T. Did the first Spanish horses landed in Florida and Carolina leave progeny? Am. Anthrop., 1940, 42: 90-106.—Chomel. A propos de l'histoire du cheval dans l'antiquitd. Bull. Soc. centr. mdd. vdt., Par., 1900, 54: 907.— Dirghayamas. Sacrifice du cheval. Bull. Acad. vdt. France, 1933, 6: 338-44.—Froehner, R. Zur persischen Hippologie und Hippiatrie des 11. Jahrhunderts. Vet. hist. Jahrb., 1929, 5: 33-97, 4 pl.—Haendler, E. Das Boyneburger Rossarznei- biichlein. Ibid., 1928, 4: 41-67.—Schmutzer, R. Die Sehrift des Meisters Albrecht iiber Pferdekrankheiten. Quellen Gesch. Naturwiss. Med., 1933, 4:11-35.-—Sevilla. Les formes pharma- ceutiques des hippiatres grecs. Rev. mdd. vdt., 1936, 112: 539-51. ------ L'infirmerie des hippiatres grecs. Rec. mdd. vdt., 1936, 112: 604-11.—Sudhoff. Ein lat. Rezept fiir Pferde- gallen aus dem 14. Jahrhundert. Arch. Gesch. Med., 1919, 12: 81. ---- Hygiene, care, and transportation. See also Stable. Cheyssial, M. *Essai sur l'hygiene et les maladies du cavalier. 47p. 8? Par., 1931. Page, C. E. Horses: their feed and their feet. 149p. 8? N. Y. [1883] Bass, E. Transport von Pferden auf dem Seewege. Zschr. Veterinark., 1934, 46: 1-3.—Seller, K. Die hygienische Be- deutung des maschinellen Putzens nach Versuchen an Pferd und Rind. Zschr. Infektkr. Haustiere, 1932, 41: 133-40 — Bouchet. Teinture des chevaux de robe claire. Rev. path. comp., Par., 1915, 15: 334-7.—Eckert & Fritsch. Versuche mit Pferdeputzmaschinen. Zschr. Veteriniirk., 1928, 40: 55-69, pl.—Einfuhr von Pferden zur Olympiade 1936. Reichs- gesundhbl., 1936, 11: 379.—Ewen, L. C, & Sager, F. C. Care of foals and stallions. Vet. Med., Chic, 1939, 34: 292-9.— Foelen. De la litiere. J. mdd. vdt., Lyon, 1857, 13: 120-6.— Goulart, G. Contribuicao para o transporte de cavalhada. Rev. mil. med. vet., Rio, 1938, 1: 677-84.—Habacher. F. Das Problem des Gleitschutzes der Pferde. Wien. tierarztl. Mschr., 1935, 22: 525-30.—Lepinay, L. A propos de la teinture des chevaux blancs. Rev. path, comp., Par., 1915, 15: 281.— Oliviero. La teinture des chevaux blancs. Ibid., 283-5.— Orlov, A. A. [Care of horses during the winter indoor period] Sovet. vet., 1939, 16: No. 9, 74-8.—Schmidt, H. W. Der Transport von Pferden auf dem Seewege, unter besonderer Berucksichtigung veterinardienstUcher Fragen. Zschr. Veteri- nark., 1935, 47: 209-29.—Stabile, V. M. La higiene del pie en los cabaUos. Rev. san. mil., Asuncion, 1938-39, 12: 867- 74.—Stanclift, R. J. Grooming and exercise. Vet. BuU., HORSE 796 HORSE Wash., 1929. 23: Suppl., 117- Weekenstroo. H. J. [Care of the skin in horses and the vacuum curry-comb] Tschr. dier- geneesk., 192S. 55: 012-23 ---- Injury [incl. foreign body] C'hava.vck, J. H. *Des traumatismes pene- trants de la region plantaire chez le cheval, clou dcrue [Alfort] 128p. 8! Par., 1930. Dcmeste, M. *Essai sur la pathogenie et le traitement des efforts de tendon chez le cheval de selle [Alfort] 91p. 8? Langres, 1929. Eisenmenger, C. *Des traumatismes de I'appareil locomoteur chez le cheval de selle; pathogenie; mesures preventives, recherches de pathologie chirurgicale [Alfort] 94p. 8? Par., 1926. aIarchat., C. *De l'eventration chez le cheval [Alfort] 47p. 8? Par., 1929. Rapin, C. M. J. *Sur certains efforts dc la region sus-carpienne chez le cheval; luxation de l'os sus-carpien [Alfort] 49p. 8? Par., 1929. Allen, G. S. A rare case of foieigi. body in the horse. Vet. Rec, Lond., 1941, 53: 733- Andreov,' P. P. [Preliminary dressing of gun shot wounds of the hoise during military opera- tions] Sovet. vet., 1939, 16: 70-3.—Arloing, S. Expdriences sur les accidents auxquels sont exposds les chevaux passant sur les lignes de tramways dice triques k contact superficiel, svstdme Diatto. Bull. Soc sc. vdt. Lyon, 1902, 5: 57-68.—Bergeon. Efforts de tendons chroniques. Ibid., 114-6.—Bouchet, G. Deux fractures du canon chez le cheval suivies par la radio- graphic Bull. Acad. vdt. France, 1936, 9: 445-54.—Brower, G. W. Injuries of the withers. Vet. Rec, Lond., 1928, 8: 565.—Busse, H. Zehn Jahre Reiterverletzungen. Deut. Militiirarzt, 1938, 3: 527-31.—Carda, P. La contusi6n de la cruz y su tratamiento por los antivirus. Rev. zootden., B. Air., 1929, 16: 04-71.- Cinoti, F. Lussazioni pastoro-coronali negli equidi, Nuovo orcolani, 1921, 29: 321 7. Delorme, P. Section accidentelle du tendon du l.ifemoro-calcanden; gudrison. J. mdd. vet., Lyon, 1856, 12: 145 -50. Diinemann, H. Ueber primare, einfache Strahlbeinfrakluren und ihre Diagnostik. Zschr. Veterinark., 1938, 50: 70-5, pl. -Eggert, W. K., jr. Injuries of polo ponies. Vet. Med., Chic, 1935, 30: 250.— Esclauze. Arrachement et dilaceration des apondvroses des fldchisseurs des phalanges; ddchirure du perforant. Bull. Soc centr.mdd. vdt.,Par., 1905,59:451-3.—Ismert. Morsures graves du garrot chez un cheval. Bull. Soc. sc. vdt. Lyon, 1899, 2: 140.—Joly, G. Etudes <-liiui|ues .-m les efforts de tendons des fldchisseurs des phalanges. Bull. >r,c centr. mdd. vdt., Par., 1900, 54: 236-42 —Knowles, R. H. Fracture of the os suffra- ginis. J. R. Army Vet. Corps, 1941-42, 13: 60.—Lagaillarde Etiologie des blessures de harnachement dans la cavalerie; modifications k apporter au paquetage de campagne. Rev. vet. mil., Par., 1930, 14: 393-400.—Leuthold, A. Zwei Falle von Strahlbeinfraktur beim Pferd. Berl. tierarztl. Wschr., 1938, 54: 213.—Levaggi, G. Algunas consideraciones sobre las fracturas de los sesamoides en el caballo de carrera; el empleo del filete y el freno con respecto a su frecuencia. Rev. zootden., B. Air., 1936, 23: 17S-86—MacKenzie, P. Z. A fractured pastern. Vet. J., Lond., 1938, 94: 354, pl.—Marcenac. Les fractures du sus-carpien chez le cheval et leur diagnostic radiographique. BuU. Acad. vet. France, 1933, 6: 159-62.— Matrion. Rupture de la bride fibreuse interne de la calotte du calcandum; ddviation permanente du tendon du perford; gudrison. Bull. Soc. sc. vet. Lyon, 1899, 2: 176-9.—Olivier. Plaie profonde produite sur l'encolure d'un cheval par l'ex- trdmite du brancard d'une charrette; guerison. J. med. vet., Lyon, 1853, 9: 269-73.—Organisation des services de secours aux chevaux blessds de l'Armee anglaise. Rev. path, comp., Par., 1915, 15: 192-4.—Parent. Blessures au p&turage; responsabilitd des aubergistes et des maitres d'hotel; louage de chevaux. J. mdd. vdt., Lyon, 1864, 20: 235-43.—Plantureux. Blessures de harnachement. Rev. vdt. mil., Par., 1931, 15: 239-50.—Railliet. Effets du froid excessif et des briilures sur l'organisme des dquidds. Bull. Soc. centr mdd. vdt., Par., 1881, 35: 343-53.—Rey, A. Chevaux blesses ou tuds sur le chemin de fer de Paris ;l Lyon; responsabilitd de la compagnic J mdd. vet., Lyon, 1864, 20: 173-81.—Schahin, D. Ruptur der Sehne des M. extensor carpi radiahs bei einer 4jahrigen Suite mit bleibender Hyperextension im Carpalgelenk. Zschr Veterinark., 1937, 49: 423-5. ---- Inspection. Aepli, A. *BetrachtUngen iiber die Messung der oberen Extremitatenwinkel sowie neue Mess- und Beobachtungsversuche durch die Filmauf- nahme beim Pferd [Zurich] 36p. 24 J/, cm Frauenfeld, 1937. Krymtz [H. A. F.] YV. *Kritisehe Betrach- tungen iiber den Wert der Hippometrie bei der Beurteilung der Leistungsfahigkeit der Ge- brauchspferde [Bern] ().>p. S? Hannov., 1911. Boli.in, P. ""Contribution a la determination dc lage d('^ solipedes; le signe dit de Galvavnc [Alfort] .J4p. 8? Par., 1934. Tisseck, H. ""Identification du cheval par les empreintes palatines. 47p. 2.">cm. Lyon, 1939. Bressou. La ddtermination de l'&ge du cheval. Rev. vdt. mil., Par., 1930, 14: 283-91.— Errington, B. J., & Shipley, W. I). Examinations of the eyes of horses and mules. Vet. Bull., Wash., 1941, 35: 90-105.—Gibbons, W. J. The physical examination of the eye of the horse Ibid., 1940, 34: 107 72.— Hicks, T. The examination of the horse as to soundness. Vet. Rec, Lond., 1932, 12: 629-38.— Hollstein. Altersbe- stimmung bei Pferden mit Hilfe der Augenkunde nach Seekanip. Zschr. Veteriniirk., 1936, 48: 481 6. Jakob, H. Einiges iibei Hauptmangel, Vertragsniangel beziehuugsueise zugesiehci le Eigenschaften beim Kauf von Pferden und Kindeni. Deut tierarztl. Wschr., 1936, 44: 199-504.- Magerl. Ueber Lei- stungsbeurteilung des Pferdes durch Messungen, \\ iigungen und Leistungspriifungen. Miinch. tierarztl. Wschr., 1937, 88: 49-54.—Muller, von. Die Bedeutung der Brust masse fin die Beurteilung des Pferdes. Zschr. Veterinark., 1933, 45: 321-50.—Nitsche, O. Das unspezifischc; Granulationsgewcbc des Pferde^; Beitrage zu seiner Altersbestimmung. Ibid., 1929, 41: 385-405.—O'Leary, H. The examination of horses for soundness. Vet. Rec, Lond., 1937, 17: 445-50.—Ullmann, G. Das Gitschen (Junginaclien) der Pferde. Arch. wiss. prakt. Tierh.. 1938-39, 74: 4 11-9.—Wiechert. Messungen an ostpreussischen Kavalleriepferden und solchen mit besonderen Leistungen und die Beurteilung der Leistungsfahigkeit auf Grund der mechanischen Vei-hiilfiiis.se. Zschr. Veterinark., 1927, 39: 158-68. ---- Insurance. Dechambre, E. E. *Les assurances des chevaux contre les accidents [Alfort] 51p. 8°. Par., 1927. Schweighauser, F. Fragen aus der Pferdeversicherung; 5 Falle. Munch, tierarztl. Wschr., 1938, 89: 136-8 ---- Laws and regulations. Barral. Le droit d'entrde sur les chevaux. J. mdd. vdt., Lyon, 1868, 24: 45.—Einfuhr von Einhufern aus dem Genend- gouvernement (Verordnung) Vorschr. siit-hs. Vet., 1940, 35: 141. Equine diseases mentioned in the horse breeding acts of Great Britain. North Am. Vet., 1937, 18: 32-4.—Mitchell, W. M. A general consideration of the disease conditions men- tioned in the horss breeding acts. Vet. Rec, Lond., 1936, 16: 1365 -82.—Rey, A. Rdvision de la loi du 20 mai 1838 sur les vices rddhibitoiios par la Socidtd centrale de mddecine vdtdrinaiie. J. mdd. vdt., Lyon, 1860, 15: 193-200. ---- Mare [and diseases] Caslick, E. A. The sexual cycle and its relation to ovulation with breeding records of the thoroughbred mare. Cornell Vet., 1937, 27: 187-206.—Ewen, L. C, & Sager, F. C. Care of the broodmare. Vet. Med., Chic, 1939, 34: 220-8.—Jesina, F. [Bang infection on horses] AUatorv. lap., 1933, 56: 320-2.— Mosse. Fievre intermittente quotidienne observde sur une jument. J. mdd. vdt., Lyon, 1860,16: 140-4.—Pembrey. C. W. The effects of chill on a mare. Vet. J., Lond., 1940, 96: 211 — Sato, S., & Hoshi, S. Researches on reproduction in mares; periodic changes in vulva, vagina and cervix. J. Jap. Soc. Vet. Sc, 1938, 17: 89-109.—Sejkora, K. [On the changes in size and body build in the mares of the Hucul horse studs] Zvdr. obzor, 1939, 32: 97-108.—Zwick, W. Virus-Abortus der Stuten. In Handb. Viruskr. (E. Gildemeister [et al.)] 1939, Jena, Bd 2, 736-9. ---- Military aspect. Moore, J. Our servant the horse; an apprecia- tion of the part played by animals during the War, 1914-18. 31p. 8? Lond., 1934. Ramelet, A. L. *De l'aptitude du cheval irlandais a etre utilise comme cheval d'armes en Suisse. 40p. 8? Ziir., 1926. Bcrner. Wehrkreispferdelazarette und Krankenstalle der Wehrmacht. Deut. tierarztl. Wschr., 1936, 44: 135-9 — Brauning. Vergleichende Untersuchungen uber die Herztatig- keit bei Dienstpferden des Standorte.s Neustadt (Oberschl.) Zschr. Veteriniirk., 1933, 45: 433-43.- Burger. Erfahrungen aus den grossen Gebrauchspriifungen fiir Gespanne im Jahre 1935. Deut. tierarztl. Wschr., 1936, 44: 144-8.—Buhle. P. Ueber schwere Zugpferde (Kaltbluter) im Heeresdii ust. Mil. Wbl., Berl., 1936-37, 121: 2819.—Cambau. Guide de 1 odicicr acheteur. Bull. Acad. vdt. France, 1935, 8: 455-62. Canard. Remonte miUtaire et aUmentation des dquidds dan* le nord de Madagascar. Rev. vdt. mil., Par., 1938, 22: 219-33.—Carnus. Le probldme du cheval de guerre, Rec. mdd. vdt., 1939, 115: HORSE 797 HORSE 672-702.—Cavalry in our next war. J. Am. Vet. M. Ass., 1940, 97: 62.—Chladek, V. [Infectious diseases of army horses in times of peace] Voj. zdrav. listy, 1931, 7: 26-36. [Turf as bedding for army horses] Ibid., 1933, 9: 81-7.— Corrda Leal, A. A missao educativa dos servicos de remonta e veterinaria do Exercito. Rev. mil. med. vet., Rio, 1938, 1: 635-7.—Decision ministdrielle pour la mise au vert des chevaux de toutes armes. J. mdd. vdt., Lyon, 1855, 11: 329-33.— DeVine, B. The horse in war-time; the economics of horse maintenance. Vet. Rec, Lond., 1940, 52: 119.—Dorfman, S. Campeonato del caballo de oficial; contribucion para la prepara- tion de jinetcs y caballos. Rev. mil., B. Air., 1939, 39: pt 2, 1237-57.—Fishman, F. [Saddling the technique of sanitary service] Voy. san. delo, 1936, 3-5.—Gaggermeier. Maultier und Klein pferd im militiirischen Gebirgsdienst. Zschr. Veteri- nark., 1935, 47: 353-67.—Gareis. Der Oberliindcr als Solda- tenpferd. Munch, tierarztl. Wschr., 1935, 86: 253-5.— Gomolka. Die Futtersiitze der Verpflegungsvorschriften von den Jahren 1902 und 1926 und ihre Beziehungen zur Kolik. Zschr. Veteriniirk., 1928, 40: 369-75.—Hardy, E. N. The horse and the Army. Vet. Bull., Wash., 1940, 34: 176.—Herr, J. K. Why should the United States lag behind other great powers in the military use of animals? J. Am. Vet. M. Ass., 1942, 100: 101-13.—Hofe. Erfahrungen des Veterinarofnziers bei einer Kommission zum Ankauf volljahriger Pferde. Zschr. Veteriniirk., 1938,- 50: 50-70.—Hogg, J. E. Horses for the U. S. Army. J. R. Army Vet, Corps, 1941-42, 13: 54.—Horse decontamination demonstration. Vet. Rec, Lond., 1940, 52: 345.—Horse (The) in war. Vet, Bull., Wash., 1940, 34: 186 — Horse (The) in world-wide demand. Vet, Rec, Lond., 1941, 53: 672.—Jacob. Observations varides sur l'hygidne du cheval de troupe. J. mdd. vdt., Lyon, 1847, 3: 35; 75.—Lonsdale. Soins donnds aux chevaux sur le champ de bataille; beau travail vdtdrinaire. Rev. path, comp., Par., 1915, 15: 138-40.— buna, B. Caballos para el Equipo hfpico militar de saltos. Rev. san. mil., Habana, 1938, 2: 53.—McGinnis, V. W. Cen- tral American horse in the United States Army. Vet. Bull., Carlisle Barracks, 1940, 34: 25-30.—Mitaut. Maladie d'accli- matation dite typhoide des chevaux de l'armde. Mdm. Soc. centr. mdd. vdt., Par., 1870, 7: 169-245.—Moore, J. The horse indispensable in war. Vet. Bull., Wash., 1933, 27: 385.— Mossdorf. Betrachtungen iiber die heutigen Anforderungen an das Truppenreitpferd. Zschr. Veteriniirk., 1933, 45: 443-54.— Neto Formosinho, A. O cavalo e o servigo de remonta do exercito. Rev. mil. med. vet., Rio, 1939, 2: 837-9.—Opper- mann, T., Meyer, W„ & Lowe, K. W. Untersuchungen iiber Beziehungen zwischen Blutausriistung, Exterieur und Leistung bei Truppenpferden. Zschr. Veteriniirk., 1937, 49: 157-89.— Perkuhn, W. Die Beeinflussung der Standwinkel durch die Reitausbildung bei 4- und ojahrigen Warmblutpferden. Arch wiss. prakt. Tierh., 1935-36. 70: 153-68.—Rek, L. The mineral metabolism in military horses. Vet, Bull., Wash., 1937, 31: 59-62.—Sava, I. [CoUaboration of the horse with the motor in economical life and national defense] Rev. vet. mil., Bucur., 1939, 10: 155-208.—Selmer, I. H. [Report on Army horses] Medded. Haerens Heste, 1934, 28: 20.—Spah, K. Welche Anforderungen stellt die Wehrmacht an die Remonten? Berl. tierarztl. Wschr., 1939, 55: 430.—Velu, H. Les mdthodes modernes d'utilisation du cheval et l'avenir du cheval de guerre. Rev. vdt. mil., Par., 1935, 19: 517; 1936, 20: 109-24— Wall, R. F. Remount duty and remounts. Vet. J., Lond., 1940, 96: 133-44.------ Remounts; purchasing duty and examination for soundness and serviceabiUty. Vet. Rec, Lond., 1940, 52: 176-9.—War Department Circular No. 182: average prices paid for horses and mules; fiscal year 1941. Vet. Bull., Carlisle, 1941, 35:278. ---- Moon blindness. See under Ophthalmia. ---- mount. Hetyessy, I. [Callosities under the saddle] AUatorv. lap., 1932, 55: 160.—KShler. Inwieweit konnen reiterliche Schwierig- keiten des Pferdes zu diagnostischen Irrtiimern Veranlassung geben, und wie sind diese Irrtiimer zu vermeiden? Zschr. Veterinark., 1937, 49: 49; 81.—Mitaut. Les blessures produites par la selle. Mdm. Soc. centr. med. vdt., Par., 1875, 8: 519- 89.—Rasberger. Bemerkenswertes iiber Ausbildung, Ver- wendung und Haltung der Bergreitpferde. Zschr. Veteriniirk,, 1937, 49: 380-91.—Schilling. Die Haarwirbel des Kopfes und Halses in bezug auf die Kopf- und Halshaltung des Pferdes beim Reiten. Zschr. Veterinark., 1926, 38: 278-82.—Townsend, C. H. S. The modern school of thought on the practical effect of certain unsoundnesses on the serviceability of riding horses. Vet. Rec, Lond., 1935, 15: 1111-24. ---- Paleontology. Gazin, C. L. A study of the fossil horse remains from the upper pliocene of Idaho. p.281-320. 8? Wash., 1936. Antonius, O. Die Pferde als aussterbende Tiergruppe. Biol, gen., Wien, 1931, 8: 33-44.—Chard, T. An early horse skeleton. J. Hered., 1937, 28: 317-9.—Nitsche, M. Unter- suchungen uber fossile Pferdereste Bohmens und ihre Bezie- hungen zu einigen rezenten und fossilen Pferderassen (ein Bei- trag zur Abstammung der Pferderassen) Zschr indukt Ab- stamm 1929 51: 146-244.-Romer, A. S. A lower mioctne 5"sevAnchithenum agatense (Osborn) Am. J. Sc, 1926 12- 32o-3o—Sanson, A. Sur les dquidds quaternaires. Bull. Soc anthrop. Pans, 1884, 3..ser., 7: 37-51. ---- Parasite. See also under proper names of parasites as Anoplocephalidae. Cameron, A. E. Parasites of horses. 22p 8? Ottawa, 1935. Jouveatjx. *Le clavier equin; dans la luttc contro les affections parasitaires de I'appareil digestif chez le cheval [Alfort] 48p. 8? Le Mans, 1928. Parnell, I. W. Redworms in horses. 12p. 8? [Montreal] [1936] Boley, L. E., Levine, N. D. [et al.] Treatment of Percheron horses for gastrointestinal parasites with a phenothiazine- carbon disulfide mixture. J. Am. Vet, M. Ass., 1941, 99: 408- H-—Bryant, J. B. County-wide eradication of'equine para- sites. Ibid., 1932, 80: 213-24.—Buxton. P. A. A parasitic fibroma on equines in Samoa. Parasitology, Lond., 1927, 19: 352, pl.—Coquot & Moussu, R. Sur une mycose inddterminde des glandes salivaires du cheval. Rev. mdd. vdt,, 1927, 103: 137-42.—Cramer, E. J. Observation and clinical data on the use of oil of chenopodium in the treatment of intestinal para- sites in horses. Vet. Bull., Wash., 1930, 24: Suppl., 194-7.— De Blieck, L., & Baudet, E. A. R. F. [Carbon tetrachloride as a remedy for worms in horses] Tschr. diergeneesk., 1924, 50: 257-62.—Dimock, W. W. Equine breeding diseases and a reference to intestinal parasites. North Am. Vet,, 1931, 12: 17-28.—Ehlers. Beitrag zur Bekampfung der Pferdeliiuse in den Truppenpterdebestanden unter besonderer Beriicksichti- gung des Derrilavols. Zschr. Veterinark., 1939, 50: 496-506.— Faure, L. Traitement des helminthiases dquines par le pdtrole. Ann. parasit., Par., 1939-40, 17: 590-2.—Foster, A. O., & Habermann, R. T. Endoparasites of aged horses and mules at the Beltsville research center of the U. S. Department of Agriculture. Proc. Helminth. Soc. Washington, 1940, 7: 85-7.—Gartner, W. Neuere Erfahrungen in der Behandlung der Sklerostomiasis und Ascariasis des Pferdes. Deut. tier- arztl. Wschr., 1930, 38: 305-9.— Hare, F. Notes on anthel- mintic medication in horses. North Am. Vet., 1934, 15: 37.— Harwood, P. D., Habermann, R. T. [et al.] Preliminary obser- vations on the effectiveness of crude, unconditio ed pheno- thiazine for the removal of worms from horses. Proc Helminth. Soc Washington, 1940, 7: 18-20.—Hornung, J. Zusammen- fassung von 7 nicht veroffentlichten Arbeiten iiber Wurmbefall und Wurmbekampfung bei den Pferden. Zschr. Vetrinark., 1934, 46: 241-54— Ivanchenko, V. G. [On dehelminthization of horses with sulphite of tetrachloride] Sovet. vet., 1939, 16: No. 9, 47.—James, H. D. A tvpe survey of parasitic ova in the feces of military horses. Vet. Bull., Wash., 1941, 35: 46-51 — Lagaillarde. Contribution k 1'dtude des helminthiases du cheval. Bull. Acad. vet. France, 1934, 7: 190-4.—Leiper, R. T. Check-list of helminthes parasitic in equines. J. London School Trop. M., 1911-12, 1: 22-6. ------Pillers, A. W. N. [et al.] Intestinal parasitism in the horse and its treatment. Vet. Rec, Lond., 1927, 7: 948-55.—Martens. Interessanter Fall einer parasitaren Invasion beim Pferde. Berl. tierarztl. WTschr., 1926, 42: 23.—Morris. H. A study of intestinal parasites in horses and mules in Louisiana, with special reference to the control of colic. J. Am. Vet. M. Ass., 1932, 80: 11-7 — Nighbert, E. M., & Butcher, F. D. The control of bots, stomach worms, and large intestinal roundworms of horses. Vet. Bull., Wash., 1932, 26: 59-66.—Nikolsky, M. M. [On the necessity of increased activity in control of helminthiasis in horses] Sovet. vet., 1939, 16: No. 6, 36.—Popov, N. P. [Study of parasitic worms in horses in the lower Volga region] Vest. mikrob., 1930, 9: 581-7.—Roetti, C. Considerazioni sulle elmintiasi degli equini del Galla e Sidama. Arch. ital. sc med. col., 1938, 19: 731-7.—Schwartz, B. Gastro-intestinal para- sites of equines and control measures. J. Am. Vet. M. Ass., 1928, 73: 855-70.—Slatter, E. E., & Graham, R. Horse para- site control in Illinois. Vet. Bull., Wash., 1933, 27: 21-8 — Swales, W. E. Phenothiazine; its role in the control of parasites of horses. Canad. J. Comp. M., 1942, 6: 50-4.—Thompson, A. T. Carbontetrachloride in the treatment for internal para- sites of the horse. Vet. Bull., Wash., 1933, 27: 261-3 — Tratamento das verminoses dos cavalos pelo petroleo, kerozene. Biologico, S. Paulo, 1940, 6: 193.—Turner, W. G. The treat- ment of worm parasites in horses. North Am. Vet,, 1928, 9; No. 11,29-31. ------ Experiments in the treatment and con- trol of internal parasites in horses. Vet. Bull., Wash., 1928, 22: Suppl 88-94. Vajda, T. [Treatment of helminthiasis in the horse with cift-tok] AUatorv. lap., 1936, 59: 280-2.—Whitney, C. C, & King, P. R. Observations in connection with the treatment of remount animals (horses) for intestinal parasites. Vet. Bull., Wash., 1929, 23: Suppl., 4-19.—Wight, A. C. An intestinal parasite of the horse. Ibid., 1930, 24: Suppl., 156- 60.—Wright, W. H. The present status of anthelmintiemedi- cation for gastroinlestinal parasites of the horse. J. Am. Vet. M. Ass., 1934. 84: 11-24. HORSE 798 HORSE ---- Physiology. Borcberdt, YV. [W. V.] *Studien iiber die Spningbewegung des Pferdes [Bern] 31p. S? Berl., 1912. Also Zschr. Veteriniirk., 1913, 25: Balas, G. [Equilibrium of the horse] AUatorv. lap., 1939, 62: 310.—Brocq-Rousseu, Rousse], G., & Gallot. La rdserve alcaline du cheval. C. rend. Soc. biol., 1929, 101: 1020.— Carnus. Contribution a l'etude de la cindmatique du cheval. Rev. vdt. mil., Par., 1935, 19: 563-70, 2 pl.—Diaz Yolde, J. A. El caballo de remonta y la clasificaei6n de grupos sangufneos. Rev. mil., B. Air., 1941, 41: pt 2, 339-44.—Frischbier. Ver- suche iiber die Festigkeit, Dehnbarkeit und Elastizitat der wichtigsten St reck- und Beugesehnen des Pferdes. Zschr. Veterinark., 1928, 40: 273-304.—Kronacher, C, & Ogrizek. A. Cliedmassenwinkelung und Schrittverhaltnisse beim Pferd. Biol gen., Wien, 1931, 8: 187-212.—Nye, E. L. Horses in extreme temperature. Vet. Bull, Wash., 1937, 31: 93-6.— Protasenia, T. P. [Physiological and biochemical changes dur- ing various stages of thirst in the horse] Sovet. vet., 1939, 16: 63-5.—Scheunert, A., & Miiller, C. Einfluss von Bewegung und sportlicher Hochstleistung auf die Blutbeschaffenheit des Pferdes. Arch. ges. Physiol., 1926, 212: 468-76.—Schneider, M. Untersuchungen iiber die Senkungsgeschwindigkeit der roten Blutkorperchen und iiber die Viskositat des Blutes und des Serums von Zuchtpferden. Miinch. tierarztl. Wschr., 1927, 78: 382—4.—Simon. Anatomische Bemerkungen zu den im Sankt Georg iiber die Riickentatigkeit eines richtig gehenden Pferdes und iiber Versammlung erschienenen Artikeln. Zschr. Veteriniirk., 1926, 38: 97-109. ---- Poisoning. Chelle, P. L. Quelques intoxications aUmentaires chez les dquidds. Rec mdd. vdt., 1940, 116: 5-16.—Fischer, E. Empoisonnement des chevaux d'une dcurie par l'usage de la paUle rouillde. J. chim. mdd., Par., 1865, 5. sdr., 1: 317-20 — Hintersatz. Ueber gehiiufte Erkrankungen an Magendarm- entziindungen, verbunden mit heftigen Kolikerscheinungen nach Aufnahme von verdorbenem Hafer. Zschr. Veterinark., 1928, 40: 456-62.--Parent, R. Loco-horse; maladie observde au cours dune mission aux Etats-Unis. Rev. path, comp., Par., 1910, 16: 361-3.-—Saim Pekmen [Is rye straw injurious?] Askeri tibbi baytari mecmuasi, 1936, 13: 360-4.—Sidorov, N. V. [Erroneous diagnosis of Borna's disease in horses poisoned by feeding] Tr. eksp. vet. med., Moskva, 1930, 6: 37-47, 3 pl. ---- Race. See also Horse breeding. Attard, R. *Le cheval en Algerie et parti- culierement dans le D6partement de Constantine [Alfort] 72p. 8? Par., 1933. Aubry, P. *La reproduction et l'^levage du cheval de pur-sang anglais au Haras de Menneval (Euro) [Alfort] 89p. 8? Langres, 1929. Barafrotjkhteh, A. M. *Le cheval en Perse [Alfort] 79p. 8? Par., 1931. Baudeatj, H. *Le cheval de trait de l'Auxois. 55p. 25cm. Lyon, 1934. Becker, C. *Untersuchungen iiber den Zucht- aufbau der Hengststamme des Schleswiger Pferdes [Bern] 144p. 8? Hannover, 1916. Bertin, V. L. C. *Etude sur la formation et les caracteres des chevaux du Maine [Alfort] 37p. 8? Par., 1930. Blummert, H. *Der Einfluss des Pinzgauer Pferdes auf die Oberlander Pferdezucht in Ober- bavcrn und Franken [Munchen] 107p. 8: Kallmiinz, 1938. Chavigxy, P. C. A. *Au berceau de la race percheronne; essai historique [Alfort] 44p. 8" Par., 1930. Claude, C. H. E. *Le cheval barbe; la race barbe est-elle en degene>escence en Algerie? [Alfort] 83p. 8? Par., 1927. Colix, A. *Essai sur le cheval de trait du Maine [Alfort] 75p. 8? Par., 1930. Corxec, J. P. M. *L'exploration du cheval Breton et particulierement de celui du Finistere [Alfort] 116p. 8? Par., 1931. Geiger, J. *Geschichte des Rottaler Pferdes [Miinchen] 77p. 21cm. Quakenbruck, 1938. Gotzmaxx, W. *Die Zuchtverhaltnisse der Percherons nebst Yergleich ihrer Formen mit denen der Boulonnais und Belgitr auf Grund angestellter Messungen [Jena] 81p. 8? Mcrsc- burg, 1911. Graze, H. *Dic Blutlinien der alten ober- lander Pferdezucht in Oberbaycrn [Miinchen] 112p. 21cm. Quakenbruck, 1938. Gcbler, F. *Der Aufbau der wichtigsten Hengstenfamilien der schwoizerischen Jura- Pferdezucht. 59p. 24cm. [Zur.] 193S. Loth, H. *Der Einfluss des arabischen Blutes auf die pfalzische Warmblutzucht [Miin- chen] 63p. 21cm. Bresl., 1937. Malicke, G. *Studien iiber Rassenmerkmalc bei Pferden [Bern] 79p. 8? Berl., 1910. Pas, L. van de. *Aktuelle Evolutions-Er- scheinungen bei dem siidamerikanischen Pferde. 38p. Bern, 1912. Saint-Cyr, J. *L'elevage du cheval dcmi-sang de la Dombes. 96p. 25cm. Lyon, 1934. Tayeh, F. *Les chevaux arabes et les chevaux syriens. 80p. 24J4cm. Toulouse, 1934. Thibault, J. *La race chevailine percheronne; formation, expansion et debouches [Alfort] 72p. 8? Par., 1930. Aureggio. Chevaux barbe, arabe et pur sang anglais en Algdrie. Bull. Soc. sc. vdt. Lyon, 1902, 5: 237-45.—Balden- weck. Quelques renseignements sur une petite familie de chevaux du ddpartment du Bas-Rhm. J. mdd. vdt., Lyon, 1859, 15: 29; 82.—Beebe, S. O. Five thousand years of the Arab horse. J. Hered., 1940, 31: 133.—BourgSs, J. Note sur les dquidds du Nord de la Chine. Bull. Soc. centr. mdd. vdt., Par., 1903, 57: 398-407.—Cormier, C. Le cheval berrichon dans l'lndre. Ibid., 1902, 56: 240-5.—Daumas. Les chevaux du Sahara. J. mdd. vdt., Lyon, 1852, 8: 66; 1853, 9: 220; 1856, 12: 503.—Gayot, E. Chevaux beiges du Hainaut et de la province de Namur. Ibid., 1855, 11: 420-7. ------ Chevaux beiges du Brabant, de La Hesbaye, du Condroz et des Ardennes. Ibid., 494-501.—Gourdon & Naudin, E. Apercu gdndral sur la race chevaline de 1'Algdrie; particulidrement dtudide dans la province d'Oran. Ibid., 1847, 3: 288; 329; 444.—Hank6, B. L'origine del cavaUo ungherese. Riv. biol., 1936, 20: 165-92, 2 pl.—Horses in Japan. Vet. Bull., Wash., 1940, 34: 178-85 — Kwaschnin-Ssamarin, N. Studien iiber die Herkunft des ostcuropaischen Pferdes. Acta Univ. Tartu (1930) 1931, 21: A, 1-139, 4 pl.—L., J. V. The blood of the Arab. North Am. Vet., 1941, 22: 478.—Leue. TierarztUches iiber das Nydam- pferd in Kiel. Berl. tierarztl. Wschr., 1937, 53: 519.—Martell, P. Zur Geschichte des Hauptgestiits Trakehnen. Miinch. tierarztl. Wschr., 1926, 77: 624-6.—Mattos, M. M. Apuntes de zootecnia; origen del caballo americano. An. Esc. vet. Uruguay, 1929, 1: 210; passim.—Mohler, J. R. Nonius horses and Puli dogs. J. Am. Vet. M. Ass., 1940, 96: 493.—Pascu, S., & Romascanu, G. [Observations on the Houtsoul horse] Rev. vet. mil., Bucur., 1943, 5: 84-8.—Reese, H. H. The Arabian horse in America. J. R. Army Vet. Corps, 1939, 10: 59-64.—Rouaud. Les chevaux de l'Ouest. Rev. vdt., Toulouse, 1920, 72: 208-16.—Shinn, F. W. The native Panamanian horse. Vet. Bull., Wash., 1927, 20: Suppl., 110-13.—Solanct. E. Le cheval argentin, raza criolla. Bull. Acad. vdt. France, 1939, 12: 254-64.—Stigmates hdrdditaires des races chevalines. In Notice Inst. Pasteur Alg'drie, 1934, 1: 326.—Tovar, D. A. The Equidae in Peru. Vet. Med., Chic, 1938, 33: 414.—Van Autgaerden. Le cheval beige; k propos d'une opinion alle- mande. Echo vdt., Lidge, 1913-14, 42: 254-9.—Vetulani, T. Tarpan und polnisches Landpferd (Konik) (BeitraT zur Her- kunft des europiiischen Hauspferdes) Biol, gen., Wien, 1928, 4: 387-402.—Villard, P. Divagacoes em torno do cavalo drabe. Rev. mil. med. vet., Rio, 1939, 2: 959-66. ---- Race horse. See also Horse race. Bocquet, H. *Le cheval de pur sang Anglais de course; son stud-book [Alfort] 77p. 8°. Par., 1931. Cotjderc, A. *Des exostoses et de fractures chez le cheval de courses [Alfort] 59]). 8°. Par., 1926. Gobert, H. J., & Cagny, P. Le cheval de course; 61evage, hygiene, entrainement, maladies. 510p. 8? Par., 1911. Reichexbach, A. M. *Die Gliedmassen- erkrankungen der Galopprennpferde; ihre Ursa- chen, ihre Behandlung mit dem Cauterium actuale und ihre Nachbehandlung. 67p. 8? Lpz., 1925. HORSE 799 HORSE Barrier, G. Valeur de la richesse globulaire du sang chez les chevaux de vitesse. Rec. mdd. vdt., 1914, 91: 446-54. Effets brisants du travail en mode de vitesse sur le squelette des membres, chez les chevaux de courses. Bull. Acad. vdt. France, 1939, 12: 38-48.—Cagny. Les hdmorragies des chevaux de courses. Bull. Soc. centr. mdd. vdt., Par., 1899, 53: 156- 63.—Catlett, J. G. Pre-race examinations. J. Am. Vet. M. Ass., 1942, 100: 205-7.—Guoth, von. Beinhautentziindung der dorsalen Wand des Metacarpus und die Transformation der Knochenstruktur bei Rennpferden. Arch. wiss. prakt. Tierh., 1927, 56: 159-77.—Haglock, J. G. Bandage for race-horses U. S. Patent Off., 1902, No. 715,059.—Hornyacsek, J. Obsti- pationen bei Rennpferden nach Beendigung der Rennsaison. Wien. tierarztl. Mschr., 1928, 15: 456.—Laughlin, H. H. Racing capacity in the thoroughbred horse; the measure of racing capacity; the inheritance of racing capacity. Sc. Am. Month., 1934, 38: 210; 310.—Marshall, F. R. The age of speed sires. Am. Natur., 1910, 44: 431-3.—Ridgeway, W. The colours of race-horses. Nature, Lond., 1919-20, 104: 334. ---- Serology. See also Serum. Ando, K., Kee, R., & Manako, K. Studies on serum frac- tions; differences in the antigenic structure of different horse sera. J. Immun., Bait., 1937, 32: 83-96.—Baldassi, G. Polari- mdtrie et rdfractomdtrie de sdrums de cheval, normaux et immuns, en tenant particulidrement compte de la dispersion rotatoire. BoU. Sez. ital, Soc. internaz. microb., 1934, 6: 407-14. ------ Sulla determinazione quantitativa del potassio nei siero di cavallo. Diagn. teen, lab., Nap., 1935, 6: 948-51.—Boutaric, A., & Roy, M. Dispersion rotatoire du sdrum de cheval. C. rend. Soc. biol., 1939, 130: 862.—Brand, E., & Kassell, B. Absence of methionine in crystalUne horse serum albumin. J. Biol. Chem., 1941, 141: 999.—Brocq- Rousseu, D., Boutaric, A., & Roy, M. Recherches compld- mentaires sur quelques proprietds _ physico-chimiques de sdrums provenant des saigndes successives d'un mdme cheval. BuU. Acad, mdd., Par., 1939, 3. ser., 121: 158-65 Floculation, en milieu faiblement tamponnd, des sdrums prove- nant de saigndes successives d'un meme cheval. C. rend. Soc. biol., 1939, 130: 863-5.—Brocq-Rousseu, D., Roussel, G., & Gallot. Floculation du sdrum chez les chevaux fidvreux. Ibid., 1930, 103: 756.—Brocq-Rousseu, D., Gruzewska, Z., & Roussel, G. La composition des sdrums de chevaux fidvreux; taux de la cholesterine et du sucre d'hydrolyse. Ibid., 104: 852-4.—Brocq-Rousseu, D., Nattan-Larrier, L. [et al.] Le pouvoir anticompldmentaire du sdrum de cheval. Ibid., 1938, 128: 587-90.—Chanoz, M., & Ponthus, P. Densitd optique, en fonction pH, des dilutions de sdrum de cheval par l'eau distillde ou la solution physiologique de NaCl. Ibid., 1933, 112: 1404-7.—Conti, G. II metabolismo deU'azoto e dei cloruri dopo iniezioni di siero normale di cavaUo. Ann. ital. chir., 1938, 17: 525-42.—Creech, H. J., & Jones, R. N. The con- jugation of horse serum albumin with 1, 2-benzanthryl iso- cyanates. J. Am. Chem. Soc, 1940, 62: 1970-5.—Davidsohn, I., & Ramsdell, S. G. Horse serum as a heterophUic antigen. J. Immun., Bait., 1929, 17: 365-75.—Elford, W. J., Grabar, P., & Fischer, W. Ultrafiltration studies with normal horse serum. Biochem. J., Lond., 1936, 30: 92-9.—Fell, N., Stern, K. G., & Coghill, R. D. A physical-chemical study of normal and immune horse sera. J. Immun., Bait., 1940, 39: 223-46.— Freund, J., & McDermott, K. Sensitization to horse serum by means of adjuvants. Proc. Soc. Exp. Biol., N. Y., 1942, 49: 548-53.—Gate, J. La formol-gdhfication du sdrum chez les chevaux normaux. C. rend. Soc. biol., 1928, 98: 1331-3.— Guy, L. Passage of horse serum from the blood stream into the aqueous humor of normal and immunized animals. Am. J. Ophth., 1940, 23: 1209-16.—Hirschlaff-Lindgren, B. Der Zitronensauregehalt des Pferdeserums. Skand. Arch. Physiol., BerL, 1937, 76: 15-21.—Hyman, L. W. Cholesterol and phos- • pholipids in the plasma of immunized horses. Annual Rep. Div. Lab. N. York State Dep. Health, 1934, 23. ------ Analysis of the alcohol-ether extract of horse serum. J. Immun., Bait., 1938, 35: 71-4. Also repr.—Kekwick, R. A. Observa- tions on the crystaUizable albumin fraction of horse serum. Biochem. J., Lond., 1938, 32: 552-62.—Kofman, T. Rdactions morphologiques du sdrum de cheval chauffe. C. rend. Soc. biol., 1936, 121: 57.—Leathern, J. H., & Webster, E. C. Re- sponse of hypophysectomized male guinea pigs to pregnant mare serum. Anat. Rec, 1942, 82: 429 (Abstr.)—Luy P. Zur Refraktometrie des Pferdeserums. Deut. tierarztl. Wschr., 1934, 42: 611.—Modern, F., & Ruff, G. Polarimetna, re- fractometrfa y fraccionamiento protdico de los sueros de cabaUos normales e immunizados. Rev. Soc. argent, biol., 1936, 12: 89-101.—Mutsaars, W. Action empdehante de la gdlatine diazotde sur la prdcipitation du nitro- et diazosdrum humain par l'antinitroserum de cheval. C. rend. Soc. biol., 1938, 129: 510.—Pearson, P. B. Inorganic phosphorus of horse serum; the effect of age and nutrition. J. Biol. Cherry 1934, 106: 1-6. Also repr.—Peleskei, L. [Experiences with and investigation of horse protein introduced into the human body] Gy6gydszat, 1935, 75: 615; 640; 658.—Rimington, C, & Van Den Ende, M. Comparison of the globoglycoid, crystal- bumin, seroglycoid and seromucoid fractions of normal horse serum. Biochem. J., Lond., 1940, 34: 941-58 pl—Sandor, G., & Tabone, J. Prdsence de fonctions acdtyles instables dans les protdides du sdrum de cheval. C. rend. Acad, sc, 1938, 207: 601-3 —Tapemoux, A., Pagnon, F„ & Vuillaume, K. C ™Jf |S SU u1. md\CSod..e Amotion du sdrum sanguin de cheval. C. rend. Soc. biol 1934, 115: 1126; 1698.—Toomey, J. A., & i^IJ^r. t \ ensitjvity to horse serum due to previous injections of antigen. Am. J. Dis. Child., 1941, 62: 765-75 — Treffers, H. P., Moore, D. H., & Heidelberger, M. Quantita- tive experiments with antibodies to a specific precipitate- antigenic properties of horse serum fractions isolated by electro- phoresis and by ultracentrifugation. J. Exp M 1942 75- 135-50.—Van der Scheer, J., Wyckoff, R. W. G.,' & Clarke! t. L. An electrophoretic study of heated horse-serum. J Immun., Bait., 1941, 40: 39-45.—Wright, G. G jr The antigenic relationship between horse antibodies and the proteins of normal horse serum. J. Infect. Dis , 1942 70 ■ 103-11— Wright, G. P., & Hopkins, S. J. Reversed passive skin sensitisation to horse serum in human beings. J Path Bact., Lond., 1941, 53: 243-53. ---- Stallion [and diseases] Baylac, J. P. *Recherches sur la fecondite des etalons [Alfort] 61p. 8? Par., 1927. Deckgebuhr fur Hengste. Vorschr. sachs. Vet., 1940, 35: 61.—Dimock, W. W., & Snyder, E. Bacteria of the genital tract of mares and the semen of staUions and their relation to breeding efficiency. J. Am. Vet. M. Ass., 1923-24, 64: 288- 98.—Papp, G. [Retroflexio sigmoidea ductus deferentis in the horse] AUatorv. lap., 1938, 61: 22.—S. Aus Gutachten; Falligkeit des Deckgeldes bei Privathengsten. Miinch. tierarztl. Wschr., 1936, 87: 401-3.—Schulte-Sienbeck. Ist in dem Begriff Deckfahigkeit auch die Befruchtungsfahigkeit eingeschlossen? In Was gibt es Neues (Puttkammer, V.) Hannover, 1938, 151.—Sejkora, K. [Problems of veterinarians in selection of stalUons for stud] Zvdr. obzor, 1940, 33: 203- 11.—Sneyd, F. B. Thoroughbred staUions. Vet. J., Lond., 1940, 96: 105-7.—Sttle, G. [Covering of mares] AUatorv. lap., 1937, 60: 59-63.—Ulc, F. [Causes of loss and training of stud stallions] Zvdr. obzor, 1940, 33: 190-2.—Verordnung des Ministers des Innern betreffend Ueberwachung des Ge- sundheitszustandes der Zuchthengste. Vorschr. sachs. Vet., 1937, 32: 125.—Yager, R. H. The bacterial flora of the semen of remount stallions. Vet. Bull, Wash., 1941, 35: 33-7. ---- Stomatitis contagiosa pustulosa. Not to be confused with Variola equina. Bennison, J. C. Equine variola; oral form or equine con- tagious pustular stomatitis. J. R. Army Vet. Corps, 1941-42, 13: 48-53.—Burton, A. C. Stomatitis contagiosa in horses. Vet. J., Lond., 1917, 73: 234-42.—Jakimov, W. L., & Nikolsky. S. N. Zur Frage der Spirochaten bei der pustulosen Stomatitis der Pferde. Zschr. Infektkr. Haustiere, 1931, 39: 307-10.— Mohler, J. R. Vesicular stomatitis of horses and cattle. J. Am. Vet. M. Ass., 1917-18, 52: 410-22.—Olitsky, P. K. Physical, chemical, and biological studies on the virus of vesicular stomatitis of horses; comparison with the virus of foot-and-mouth disease. J. Exp. M., 1927, 45: 969-81.— Panisset, L., & Herlin, E. A propos de 2 cas de stomatite pustuleuse contagieuse du cheval (localisation buccale du horse-pox) Rev. gdn. mdd. vdt., 1922, 31: 5-10.—Szanto, P. Stomatitis pustulosa contagiosa. Allatorv. lap., 1916, 39: 314.—Zwick. Ueber die Beziehungen der Stomatitis pustulosa contagiosa des Pferdes zu den Pocken der Haustiere und des Menschen. Deut. tierarztl. Wschr., 1924, 32: 643. ---- Surgery. Afrikantov, Pribylovsky & Shanbatuev. [Case of field surgery of a horse] Sovet. vet., 1940, 17: No. 2, 80.—Andreev, P. P. [Comparative evaluation of adhesive bandages for horses in field surgery] Ibid;, 76-9.—Eckert. Die verschiedenen Methoden der Hufknorpeloperation; ihre Vorziige und Nach- teile. Zschr. Veterinark., 1923, 35: 225733— Fatkin, N. F. [Application of anesthesia by infiltration in operations at the withers] Sovet. vet., 1940, 17: No. 2, 81-7.—Kudriavtsev, A. A., & Iakushev, V. I. [Organostomy of horses] J. Physiol. USSR, 1938, 25: 154.—Liebermann, T. [Surgical treatment of ear and larynx diseases in horses] Budapesti orv. ujs., 1926, 24: 275-9.—St. Clair, L. E., & Foust, H. L. The anatomy of the area concerned in the so-caUed Goodale ring-bone operation. North Am. Vet., 1939, 20: No. 2, 22. Also Vet. Pract., Evans- ton, 1939, 20: No. 8, 20.—Treman, H. B. Surgery of the horse's foot. J. Am. Vet. M. Ass., 1942, 100: 63. Training. Briscoe, N. B. The training of horses 14 centuries before Christ. Vet. BuU., Wash., 1935, 29: 96-8.—Claparede, E. Encore les chevaux d'Elberfeld. Arch, psychol., Gendve, 1913, 13: 244-84.—Delage, Y. Pour le controle des chevaux pensants d'Elberfeld au moyen du questionneur muet. BuU. Inst. gdn. psychol., Par., 1913, 13: 153-8.—Haenel, H. Die moderne Tierpsychologie und die Elberfelder Pferde. Jahrber. Ges. Natur. Heilk. Dresden, 1912-13, 40-4. ------ Neue Beob- achtungen an der Elberfelder Pferden. Zschr. angew. Psychol., 1913-14, 8: 193-203. Also Neur. Zbl., 1914, 33: 805-9 — Lugaro, E. Un principio biogenetico; la moltiplicazione degU effetti utiU indiretti (a proposito dei cavalh pensanti) Riv. pat. nerv., 1913, 18: 129-69.—Mangin, M. Le ddbat sur les chevaux d'Elberfeld; l'exposd d'un nouveau tdmoin: le Dr HORSE 800 HORSE Robert Assacioli. Ann. sc psych Par.. 1913, 23: 1-14 — O'Shea. M. V. The abilities "I .-m educated horse. Pop. Sc. Month.. 1913, 82: 16S 76.- Pavlosievici. T. |Training of horses in Roumania and abroad m relation to letnounts] Rev. vet. mil., Bucur. 1936, 7: 231-62. Ricciarelli. \. Ri- cerche originali -ulla i»h.'Ionia di un cavallo. Riv. psicol. appl 1914, 10: 151 7- Sanford. E. C. P>\ chic research in the animal field; dei kluge Hans and the I.lbeifeld horses. Am. J. Psychol., 1914, 25: 1-31.- Schneider, K. C. Die rechnenden' Pferde; Erwiderung auf C. Schroder's Kritik. Biol. Zhl., 1915, 35: 153-60.—Schroder. C. Die leclinendcn Pferde; eine Kritik insbe.-ondere dei K. ('. Sclineider'sclien Auffassung. Ibid., 1914. 34: 594-614. Schwantke. C. Be- merkungen zur Tierpsy< -hologie veranlasst durch den Aufsatz von Camillo Schneider; die rechnenden Pfeide. Ibid.. 1913, 33: 420-5.- Sommer. R. Anfangsunterrii lit bei den Elber- felder Pferden. Fortsch. Psychol., 1914 15. 3: 135-49.- Vladescu. I). [Training of horses in Baragan and ihe I)o- broudia] Hev. vet. mil., Bucur., 1939. 10: 61-9- Way. C. Some obektion de> Pferdes. Berl. tierarztl. \W-hr.. 1927. 43: 683.- - Bogdasrhew. N. Anatomisch-histologischer Bau der Meta- carpalkuochen und zum Teil der Metatarsalknochen einiger I'leulerissen im Zusammenhang mit ihrer Funktion. Anat. Anz., 1936, 83: 103-21.—Bresson, C. Les muscles de Philips et de Thiernesse chez les dquidds. Rev. mdd. vet., Par., 1935, 111: 5-1U. ------& Herodes, A. Les espaces conjonctifs du -arret cheZ le cheval. Rec mdd. vdt., 1929, 105: 321-8.— Chiodi. V. Sulle fascie dell'arto toia'-ico del cavallo. Clin. vet. .Milano. 1928, 51: 480-501 .—Uechambre, P. Le.s raiea de la robe du cheval. Rec med. vet., 1931, 107: 193-200.— Endre, G. G. Adatok a lovak labkozf pesont.ianak csontszer- kezetdhez es alakviiltozasairioz. kOzl. m i\a/i in .-ulle terminazioni nervose nella membrana rhera- togena deH'Kquus caballus. Profilassi, 1937, 10: 4(1 53.- Murphey, II. S. Some points on the surgical anatomy of the anterior pan of the head, including a preliminary study of the teeth and sinuses of the horse. Rep. Vet. Med. Iowa Coll, Agr., 1910. 1: 56-156, 45 pl.------Further studies of tin- ted hand sinuses. Ibid., 1917. 2:33-18. 62 pl.- Oltolenghi. M. Uiceiclie intorno al legament o-esa moideo pro-.sini:i|c(-o>prc del nodello) degli equini, con part icolaro riiruardo alle espansioni nervose. Arch. ital. anat., 1930 31. 28: 553 68. I'uder, J. Considerations sur l'anatomie de- tendons fleehisseurs du pierl chez le cheval. Bull. Soc. sc vdt. byon, I'.too, 3: 202 7. --- Mensuration des tetes dun cheval et d'une iuinent eaniaruue-. Bull. Soc. centr. med. vdt.. 1900, 54: 8.SS 90. Pinto e Silva, I*.. & Chiefli, A. Deinarcaciio ,his regioe-, da cabeca no cavalo. Rev. Fac. med. vet. 1'niv. S. I'aulo. I93S 39. 1: 79 96, 4 pl. Rouaud. Sur les indices du cheval. Kev. vet., Toulouse, 1920, 72: 539-48.—Salisbury, G. W., & Britton. J. W. The inherit- ance of equine coat color; the dilutes, with special reference to the Palomino. J. Hered., 1941, 32: 255 6(1. Schreyer, W. Dehnung und Elastizitiit der grossen Bougesehnen des l'ferde. fusses. Arch. wiss. prakt. Tierh., 1931, 03: 336 10. Selun, II. Equivalent! funzionali di una alterazione hsionomica neyl equini. Clin, vet, Milano, 1926, 48: 17; 85, pl. Stirton, R. A. Development of characters in horse teeth and the dental nomenclature. J. Mammal., 1941, 22: 434-46.— Ntrubell. Ueber die Bedeutung des Lacertus fibrosus und des Tendn femorotarseus fiir das Stehen und die Bewegung des Pferdes. Arch. wiss. prakt. Tierh., 1927 28. 57: 575-85.—Veysi Boragan [Study of the surface anatomy and colors of the horse] Askeri vet. mecmuasi, 1938, 15: 263 300.—Wokken, H. Ueber die Aus'.raiurspiinkte der \Ci knocherung des ersten und zweiten Zelienjiliedes beim Uauspfcrd. Zschr. Anat. Entw.. 1936, 106: 370- S. Zimmermann, A. [Comparative anatomy of arteries of extremities in horse] AUatorv. lap., 1932, 55: 199.—Zimmer- mann, G. [Shape and position of teeth in horse] Ibid., 1934, 57: 63. HORSE-BACK riding. See also Horsemanship. Bertz, W. W. Teaching \ oung medical department officers equitation. Vet. Bull., Wash., 1940, M: 147 51. Bridges. B. C. Why officers of the Medical I Jepa it ment should be interested in equitation. Ibid., 1932, 26: 1 1- 4. Dohnanyi, L. (Acci- dents in horse-back riding] Bratisl. lek. listy, 1937, 17: 79 83.—Equitacao (A) atravds da historia. Educ. ns., Rio, 1941, No. 50, 27; No. 51, 22; No. 52, 19.—Geldrich, J. Ueber den Energievcrbrauch beim Reiten. Bioehem. Zschr., 1927, 188: 1-14. ------ [Observations on respiratory metabolism during horseback riding] Magy. orv. arch., 1928, 29: 339-51 — Habcrling, W. Das Reiten ein Heil- und Gesundungsmittel im klassischen Altertum. In Natur Heilwissensch. (Festgabe 0. Sticker) Berl., 1930, 18-21.—Lefebvre des Noettes. La femme a califourchon. Aesculape, Par., 1933, 23: 285-8—Legge- Bourke, E. A. With the horses to the Holy Land. J. R. Army Vet. Corps, 1939-40, 11: 130-3.—Linington, P. Riding and body mechanics. .1. Health Phys. Educ, 1939, 10: 225-7 — Moore, A. Rider's bone. Lancet, Lond., 1937, 1: 264.— Severin, M. [Harmony that must exist between the move- ments of the horse and the rider] Rev. vet. mil., Bucur., 1936, 7: 431-9.—Smart, M. Rider's strain, with notes on muscle strain in general. Brit. J. Phys. M., 1934-35, 166-70.—Winn. D. F. Riders' leg. Mil. Surgeon, 1928, 63: 507-9. HORSE breeding. Arctjlaritjs, G. H. *Der Einfluss des Ulrich- steiner Gesti'its auf die hessische Pferdezucht und die Entwicklung des Landgestuts zur Staatsan- stalt [Giessen] 23p. 8? Hannover, 1919. Irouin, M. E. Contribution k l'etude de 1'elevage du cheval breton en particulier dans le Departement des C6tes-du-Nord [Alfort] 123p. 8° Saint-Brieuc, 1926. Ladrat, J. *L'organisation de l'elevage en France. 144p. 23}^cm. Toulouse, 1934. Lebotjc, G. *Une entreprise zootechnique en Annam; les etablissements d'elevage d'An-Khe. 36p. 8? Par., 1930. Levy, P. *Les sauteurs dans les piliers et en liberte, exemple d'adaptation morphologiquc fonctionnelle chez le cheval. 79p. 2.">3.">. ---- Horsemanship and horsemastership; animal management. 330p. 8? Fort Rilev, 1940. ----Horsemanship and horsemastership; education of the rider; education of the horse. 251p. 23cm. Fort Riley, 1941. Cederwald, A. A. The American Remount Association and its accomplishments. Vet. Bull., Carlisle, 1939, 33: 47-9. HORSE-POX. See under Variola; also Horse, Stomatitis contagiosa pustulosa. HORSE-RACE. See also Horse, Race horse. C'ommimgcs, A. de. De la ddfense chevaline par les concours hippiques de l'avenir. Congr. internat. sport, 1905, 151-9.— Rust. Ein Querschnitt durch den deutschen Rennsport und die deutsche Vollbhitzueht. Deut. tierarztl. Wschr., 1938, 46: 6-13.- Stewart, C. M. Racing in Northern India. J. R. Army Vet. Corps, 1941-42, 13: 46-8. HORSE-RADISH. See Cochlearia. HORSE serum. See Horse, Serology; also Serum. HORSE-SHOE. See also Hoof; Horse-shoeing. Pa.m.nickk [F. A.J W. *Auf welchen Grund- satzen beruhen die verschiedenen Xational- beschlage? [Leipzig] 79p. 8? Dresd., 1935. Rosexkraxz [M.] (1. *Gleitschutz und Huf- beschlag im Wandel der Zeiten. 71p. 8? Lpz., 1936. Asmus, H. Horseshoes of interest to veterinarians. Vet. Bull., Wash., 1930. 30, 3: 200-29.—Bauer & Farchmin. Unter- suchungen iiber die Verwendbarkeit gepanzerter Hufeisen als Heereshufbeschlag. Zsehr. Veterinark., 1939, 51: 17-25.— Burger, U. Weitere Erfaluungen mit Adet-Gummihufbeschlag. Ibid., 1937,49:103-8.—Fischer, A. Rennen auf Duraluminium; Paris erpiob oinen neuen Hufbeschlag fiir Rennpferde. Deut. tierarztl. Wsehr., 1937, 45: 148-50.— Ferrure k plaque mobile pour pansements. Bull. Soc. centr. und. vet., Par., 1900, 54: 732-5.—Froehner, R. Das Hufeisen im Wappenschild. Cheiron. Lpz., 1936, 8: 171-84.—Grapentin. Ist der Gummi- hufbeschlag fiir Heereszwecke geeignet? Zschr. Veterinark., 1938, 50: 146-59.—Hanslian, A. Der Gummihufbeschlag. Berl. tierarztl. Wschr., 1937, 53: 260.—Interest (Of) to the cavalry arm. J. Am. Vet. M. Ass., 1942, 100: 116— Nikolsky, S. P. [On the defects of the horse-shoe of draft horses in Moscow] Sovet. vet., 1939, 16: No. 10-11, 71-3.—Orhan Erkurt [Bolts instead of screws for therapeutic horseshoes] Askeri vet. mecmuasi, 1939, 17: 1-5.—Otto. Beitrage zur Beurteilung der Tragedauer des Heereshufeisens 32 und der wahrend derselben von den Pferden erzielten Marschleistung in Garnison und Manover. Zschr. Veterinark., 1938, 50: 170-7.— Pecus. Des bons effets de la ferrure Schneider dans le traite- ment de la fourbure. Bull. Soc centr. mdd. vdt., Par., 1900, 54: 151-3.—Rosier. Ueber Rehhuf und Plattenhufeisen. Berl. tierarztl. Wschr., 1937,53:808.—Semmler, W. Das Heereshuf- eisen 32. Zschr. Veterinark., 1934, 46: 172-80. HORSE-SHOEING. See also Hoof; Horse-shoe. Asmus, H. Farm horseshoeing. 28p. 8? Ithaca, X. Y., 1935. Bassi. R. L'arte di ferrare i cavalli. 2. ed. 264p. 8? Tor. [1906] Plaxtureux, M. *Appui et parer du pied; ferrure des pieds defectueux [Alfort] 64p. 8° Saumur, 1930. Adams, J. W. Shoeing and balancing. Rep. Vet. Med Iowa Coll. Agr., 1917, 2: 2>>7-30S— Ambert. De la ferrure des chevaux. J. mdd; vdt., Lyon, 1851, 7: 241-50.—Bevagna, A La ferratura podometrica nei cavallo d il sistema migliore Chn. vet., Milano, 1935, 58: 237-40.- Bieler. S. Notes sur l'liistoiie tie la ferrure. J. med. vet.. Lvon, IS57, 13: 241-8 2pl.- Boenisch. Leber Ilufl.eschl.-igfragrn. Zsehr." Veteriniirk', 1930. 42: 433-8. - Bretegnier at'erits actually paid in 100 hospi- tals, a study of 100 bills in 100 hospitals. Mod. Hosp., 1930, .14: 09-68—Mezger, W. Adjusting rates to meet increased costs Hospita s, 1941, 15: No. 5, 23.—Mikocki, A. Neurege- !ung der besonderen Gebuhren in den allgemeinen offentlichen oroar!™fnhausern in Niederdonau. Zschr ges. Krankenhauswes., \,?o « Pay-beds at St Mary's. Lancet, Lond., 1937, 2: ' 162.—Paying patients in hospitals; problem of Gloucestershire Royal Infirmary. Ibid., 1936, 1: 500.—Root, V. T. Room and service are important in establishing inclusive rates. Hosp. Management, 1941, 51: No. 6, 23.—Rorem, C. R. Patients' tees and their relation to capital investment. Mod. Hosp., 1931, 36: 97-9.—Schedule of hospital fees agreed upon between the joint committee of the American, Catholic and Protestant Hospital Associations, and the U. S. Employees' Compensation Commission as effective January 1, 1942. Hosp. Progr., 1942, 23: 63.—Scheidt, A. H. Basic considerations in formulations of rates for room, board, and general nursing care. Hospitals, 1941, 15: No. 6, 24-6.—Sweeney, W. B. What 2 years' trial proves about the flat rate dan. Mod. Hosp., 1936, 46: No. 5, 73.—Van Zandt, R. P. What 316 patients paid in 5 Rochester hospitals. Ibid., 1932, 38: 83-7.—Waldmann. Sind Erhohun- gen der Krankenhausverpflegskostensatze zur Zeit anzustreben? Zschr. ges. Krankenhauswes., 1926, 22: 463.—White, S. M. Maintaining as low hospital charges as are consistent with good care of the patient from the stand-point of the internist. Bull. Am. Coll. Surgeons, 1934, 18: 3-6.—Wisconsin hospitals raising rates to meet higher operating costs; budget controls, economy measures offered as means to maintenance of accepted stand- ards. Hosp. Management, 1942, 53: No. 2, 25. ---- Fee and rate: Collection. Bugbee, G. P. Collection systems and the problems of write-off. Tr. Am. Hosp. Ass., 1939, 41: 380-4. Also Hos- pitals, 1940, 14: No. 2, 112-4.—Davis, G. L. Paying your hospital bill. Ibid., 1939, 13: 93-6.—Davis, M. M. Trends in payment for out-patient care in voluntary hospitals. Tr. Am. Hosp. Ass., 1939, 41: 715-23.—Gail, F. B. Collection system that works. Mod. Hosp., 1940, 54: No. 5, 49-51.— Greene, J. R. Signed promissory notes aid collection of time accounts. Hosp. Management, 1942, 53: 27.—Hanna, B. M. Collections made easier with help of records department. Mod. Hosp., 1941, 56: 45.—Hibschman, H. Can a hospital hold a physician responsible for a patient's bill if the physician has vouched for the patient's financial standing'!1 Med. Econom., 1941-42, 19: No. 2, 49.—Hinsley, J. W. Credit principles operate in bad as well as good times; collection success will vary at all times with the soundness of the system and efficiency of workers, says this writer. Hosp. Manage- ment, 1934, 38: 27-9.—Hoover, F. W. An effective credit and collection system. Mod. Hosp., 1932, 38: 84.—Hospitals; hospital bills accorded priority in payment out of insolvent patient's estate. J. Am. M. Ass., 1937, 109: 1226.—Houser, G. F. An experiment in collections. Hospitals, 1940, 14: No. 3, 119.—Hueston, R. M. Credit policies that reduce losses in the small hospital. Mod. Hosp., 1929, 32: No. 4, 59-61.—Jeffries, C. D. Bad debts. Hospitals, 1940, 14: No. 12, 100-8.—Judd, A. E. Suggestions offered to minimize losses from dead beats. Hosp. Management, 1930, 29: 43.— Lander, J. E. Credit association membership aids hospital in 2 ways; reporting department gives hospital accurate picture of financial responsibility of prospective patient, while collec- tion department offers experienced, dependable service in connection with stubborn accounts. Ibid., 1932, 34: 24.— Maclver, G. A. How shall the credit department be organized to function to the greatest advantage of the hospital? Bull. Am. Hosp. Ass., 1931, 5: 67-70.—O'Brien, J. The Blue Cross plans. Hosp. Progr., 1942, 23: 116-21.—Patient's (The) bill; some credit and collection practices. Mod. Hosp., 1940, 55: No. 2, 56.—Scheidt, A. H. Teaching the public to pay. Ibid., 1941, 57: 47.—U. S. Employees' Compensation Commission increases the rates of reimbursement. Hospitals, 1942, 16: No. 3, 26-8.—Weber, J. J. How Grace Hospital, New Haven, stimulates patients' collections. Hosp. Management, 1927, 24: No. 2, 50.—Whether relative of patient is liable for patient's hospital bill. Hospitals, 1941, 15: No. 12, 19.—Wussow. W. Die Sicherung von Krankenhausforderungen bei Selbstzahlern der 3. Verpflegungsklasse. Zschr. ges. Krankenhauswes., 1939, 246.—Zenger, J. H. Collections made simpler. Mod. Hosp., 1942, 58: No. 5. 48. ---- Fire prevenlion. Baehr, G. Protection against fire. Hosp. Progr., 1942, 23: 22-4.—Boine, J. Les lecons d'une catastrophe. Rev. mid. Louvain, 1929, 374-6. Also J. sc. med. Lille, 1930, 48: pt 1, 161-3.—Dealing with the fire bomb. Hosp. Topics, 1942, 20: No. 3, 19-21.—Douthit, V. L. Is any hospital building fire- proof? Mod. Hosp., 1936, 46: No. 3, 65-7. ------ What causes hospital fires? Ibid., 77-9. ------ What to do till the fire department comes. Ibid., No. 4, 75. ------ What is expected of the personnel in case of fire. Ibid., No. 5, 65.— Echternacht, A. C. How one hospital reduced its fire and HOSPITAL ADMINISTRATION 814 HOSPITAL ADMINISTRATION X-ray hazards. Ibid., 1930, 34: 59-64.—Fire! Nurs. Times, Lond., 1937, 33: 47.—Gilbert i I he) street calamity. Lancet, Lond., 1931, 2: 1143.—Gram, E. R. Protection in hospitals. Hosp. Management, 1937, 44: No. 6, 22-4.—Gronow, W. E. von. Fcueriiberwachungs- und Feuermeldeanlagen in Kran- kenanstalten. Zsehr. ges. Krankenhauswes., 1927, 23: 33-6.— Hahn, W. Selbstschutz durch Kleinfeuerloschgerate in Krankenanstalten. Ibid., 1938, 137.—Jackson, F. W. The fire protection of hospitals and similar institutions. J. R. Inst. Pub. Health, 1937-38, 1: 269-73.—Johnson, D. Fire prevention for hospitals. Hospitals, 1936, 10: No. (I, 110-2.— Karsten, A. Neueste Feuerloschverfahren fiir Anstalten. Zschr. ges. Krankenhauswes., 1929. 25: 501-3.—Kearney, P. W. What good are fire exits if you can't use them? Mod Hosp., 1934, 42: 63-6.—Maar, L. F. New York hospitals study fire safety problem. Hosp. Management, 1940, 50: No. 1, 19-21. —---- Fire control in hospitals under emer- gency conditions. Ibid., 1941, 52: No. 5, 25. ------■ New York hospitals study fire safety problem. In Hosp. Admin. & Org. (Hosp. Management) Chic, 1942, 130-2.—McClellan, J. E. T. Fire prevention and fire protection in hospitals. Hospitals, 1941, 15: No. 7, 44.—McKinney, V. W. Fire prevention and protection. Ibid., 1940, 14: No. 7, 84-6.— Newell, H. E. The storage of nitrocellulose photographic X-ray film and combustible anaesthetics. Tr. Am. Hosp. Ass., 1929, 31: 114-21. Also Bull. Am. Hosp. Ass., 1929, 3: 758.—Outwater, W. S. The result of the survey covering hospital fire hazards. Tr. Am. Hosp. Ass., 1936, 38: 699-708. Also Hospitals, 1936, 10: 89-94.—Overton, W. J. Protecting the hospital against fire hazard. Ibid., 1937, 11: No. 11, 57.— Reducing the fire risk. Hosp. Topics, 1937. 15: No. 10, 17 — Rosrheda. F<;ueilosch wesen in Krankenanstalten. Zschr. ges. Krankenhauswes., 1928, 24: 74. - Rowell, G. Hospital fire hazards. Hospitals, 1940, 14: No. 8. 91-4.—Seltzer, W. B. Educating employes for safety. .Mod. Hosp., 1938, 51: No. 4, 56-8.—Sloan, R. P. It did happen here! Ibid., 1941, 57: No. 2, 43-6.—Stacey, J. M. Fire; it can happen here. Ibid., 56: No. 4, 47.—Stephens, C. H. Hospital personnel should be trained in use of fire extinguishers. Hosp. Management, 1942, 53: No. 2, 58-00.—Strain, C. Gas extinguishers valuable for many hospital fire hazards. Ibid., 1940, 49: No. 2, 23. Also in Hosp. Admin. & Org. (Hosp. Management) Chic, 1942, 129. Wostwig, L. Fire prevention and fire fighting. Hos- pitals, 1912, 16: No. 2, 57. ---- Food supply. Boiler, A. E., & Schircliffe, A. Fruit claims its rightful place on the hospital menu. Mod. Hosp., 1933, 41: 94-102.— Bryan, W. A. Food service as a morale builder. Ibid., 1936, 47: 57-9.—Bugbee, G. P. The cost of food for personnel. Hospitals, 1936, 10: No. 12, 43-5.—Bulman, G. When the dietitian buvs food for the institution. Ibid., 1939, 13: 90-3.— Burns, H. C. Food waste. Ibid., 1941, 15: No. 11, 53.— Byrns, M. Making the most of leftovers. Mod. Hosp., 1941, 57: No. 5, 80.—Cooper, L. F. Food waste. Tr. Am. Hosp. Ass., i!)33, 35: 191-204. ------ Food service. Bull. Am. Coll. Surgeon, 1939, 24: 220-2.—Copeland, J. G. Experiences with central food service. Tr. Am. Hosp. Ass., 1931, 33: 219-28.—Escudero, P. La alimentaci6n en el hospital. Rev. As. med. argent., 1933, 46: 2264-71.—Faddis, H. Meal hours in the hospital. Tr. Am. Hosp. Ass., 1936, 38: 368-76.— Fenno, A. M. Guest or patient. J. Am. Diet. Ass., 1941, 17: 904-10.—Fraser, W. O. Federal meat grading service avail- able to hospitals. Hosp. Management, 1940, 50: No. 2, 45.— Garrison, C. J. Planning for food service. Tr. Am. Hosp Ass., 1927, 29: 352-7.—Geraghty, E. M. Organization and management of the hospital food service. Hospitals, 1939 13: No. 12, 95; 1940, 14: No. 1, 90.—Geyh, C. Verwendung von Gefrierfisch in der Heil- und Pfleganstalt Leipzig-Dosen. Zschr. ges. Krankenhauswes., 1927. 23: 70.—Guthjahr. Wie erfolgt am zweckmassigsten die Speisenbeforderung; Ibid., 593.—Jeans, P. C. The policies of the committee on foods of the American Medical Association. Hosp. Progr., 1933, 14: 455-7.—Jesser, Was haben Krankenhauser und ahn'liche Anstalten. insbesondere im Hinblick auf den Vierjahresplan, beim Einkauf, bei der Lagerung und beim Verbrauch von Lebensrnitteln zu beachten? Zschr. ges. Krankenhauswes., 1938, 25-8.—Knight, G. A. Food waste; its detection and control. Hospitals, 1938, 12: No. 4, 28.—McAuley, F. Food costs and standard procedure. Tr. Am. Hosp. Ass., 1933, 35: 187-90.—MacLachlan, M. A study of raw food costs'and service in a selected group of hospitals. Ibid., 204-6.—Marriott, W. McK. The uses of proprietary and (medicinal) foods in the hospital. J. Am. M. Ass., 1930, 94: 1281-3.—Martens, W. C, jr. Modern food service and economy. Hosp. Management] 1935, 39: 44-7.—Moos, M. Less waste in the cafeteria. Mod' Ho=p.. 1941.57: No. 4, 99.—Oehler, F. Sparsame Bewirtschaf- tung der Lebcnsmittel. Zschr. ges. Krankenhauswes., 1939, 509- 12.—Rausch, H. February dinner menus for the small hos- pital. Mod. Hosp., 1942, 58: 90.—Ross, N. Food service system in a large metropolitan hospital. Ibid., 1934, 42: 104-8.—Sexton, S. J. Purchasing groceries. Hospitals' 1941, 15: No. 6, 78.—Shaw, W. M. Serving sandwiches Hosp. Management, 1936, 42: 38-46.—Should the dietitian buy the food supplies? Mod. Hosp., 1933, 41: 77-9.—Shrader E. Efficiency and economics as applied to the administration of the food service. Bull. Am. Coll. Surgeons, 1933, 17: 24-6__ Smith, P. Food service in institutions of the New York State Department of Mental Hygiene. Am. J. Psychiat., 1934-35, 91: 1367-77.—This business of guest trays; to serve or not to serve. Mod. Hosp., 1941, 56: No. 4, 92 — Weinstock. P Freihiindiger Ankauf oder Verdineung von Lehenstnittehr' Zschr. ges. Krankenhauswes., 1926, 22: 77-9. Wilhelm, N. A. The purchasing of food supplies. Mull. Am. Hosp. Ass., 10,35' 9: 52-63. ---- Fund and endowment. Duke Endowment. Yearbook No. 9, includ- ing Annual reports of the Hospital and Orphan sections. 45p. 23cm. Charlotte, N. C. [1941] Milbank Memorial Fund. Quarterly. N. Y v.l, 1923- United States Public Works Administra- tion. P. W. A. provides modern hospitals. 48p 8? Wash., 1937. Baldridge, P. R. The processing tax provision of the Farm Relief Act as it may affect hospitals. Bull. Am. Hosp. Ass., 1933, 7: 1.—Brough, R. N., & Florence, A. Is fund raising a job for professionals? Mod. Hosp., 1941, 57: No. 6, 46.—Burns, A. T. The community chest and the hospital. Tr. Am. Hosp Ass., 1937, 39: 835-9.—District of Columbia; bill introduced [to accept gifts for the improvement, maintenance or operation of the Freedmen's Hospital] J. Am. M. Ass., 1941, 116; 1461.— Don't delay own fund-raising, FWA head warns hospitals. Hosp. Management, 1942, 53: No. 2, 26.—Federal aid to hospitals. Hosp. Progr., 1942, 23: 121.—Federal aid for hospi- tals must be accepted promptly. Hosp. Management, 1942, 53: No. 3, 28.—Four solicitors for fake hospital drive sentenced. J. Am. M. Ass., 1937, 109: 1133.—Fourteen millions is Duke's contribution to hospital care in the Carolinas. Hosp. Manage- ment, 1940, 50: No. 2, 16.—Gamble, H. A. Hospital progress in Mississippi. Hospitals, 1936, 10: No. 6, 69-72.—Jones, J. P. Fields of giving; hospitals. Ibid., 1941, 15: No. 2, 20.—Lang, C. H. History of a hospital campaign. Mod. Hosp., 1939, 52: No. 5, 58-61.—Minderman, E. One thousand eight hundred and twenty-six public hospitals aided by WPA during last 5 years. Hosp. Management, 1940, 50: No. 5, 22-4.—Mountain, J. W., & Pennell, E. H. The financial support of non-govern- ment hospitals as revealed by the recent Federal Business Census of Hospitals. Tr. Am. Hosp. Ass., 1937, 39: 707-21.— Pratt, O. G. Modern methods raise funds, ln Hosp. Yearb., 1941, 19: 927.—Schaefer, S. Motion pictures an aid in raising hospital funds. In Hosp. Admin. & Org. (Hosp. Management) Chic, 1942, 90.—Street, E. Joint hospital fund raising. Hospi- tals, 1936, 10: No. 6, 17-9.—Swanson, A. J. Winning funds and influencing people. Mod. Hosp., 1939, 53: No. 1, 46-8.— U. S. partnership with hospitals just around corner; regional and state associations hold annual meetings, elect heads. Hosp. Management, 1942, 53: No. 5, 26; 59.—Yerger, H. M. Collec- tion letters that pull. Mod. Hosp., 1941, 56: No. 2, 47-9. ---- governmental. Administration of municipal hospitals. Med. Off., Lond., 1941, 66: 146.—Branham, H. The operation of a tax-supported hospital in a small city. Hospitals, 1936, 10: No. 9, 25-7.— Castleden, L. I. M., Craig, D. B. [et al.] A municipal hospital. Brit. M. J., 1941, 2: 711.—Daly, O. P. The State hospital and welfare boards. N. Orleans M. & S. J., 1937-38, 90: 664-8 — [Debates on finance laws in the Lower House (Danish parlia- ment)] Ugeskr. laeger, 1941, 103: 1592-5.—Goto Guevara, P. La verdad sobre lo ocurrido en el Hospital general del estado. Rev. mid., Puebla, 1936-37, 9: No. 70, 6-12.—Governmental hospitals; operation of hospital by county a governmental, not a proprietary, function. J. Am. M. Ass., 1941, 117: 1559 — Lewis, M. A year of reorganization in a municipal institution; the story of a politically ignored institution and its rebirth under a humane and medically minded local government. Mod. Hosp., 1936, 46: No. 4, 65-7— Macdonald, E. K. The place of the medical officer of health in administration of the munici- pal hospital. J. State M., Lond., 1936, 44: 455-66.—Morgan, W. G. Relation of Federal, state and municipal governments to hospital maintenance. J. Am. M. Ass., 1930, 94: 909-11. Also repr.—Policies (The) of local governments with regard to hospitals. Bull. Am. Hosp. Ass., 1935, 9: 91-105. ---- Governing bodies. McNamara, J. A. What the hospital trustee should know. 83p. 12? Chic., 1931. Alter. Der Gutachterausschuss fur das offentliche Kranken- hauswesen. Klin. Wschr., 1926, 5: 2318-20.—Annual meeting of American Hospital Board. J. Am. M. Ass., 1939, 112: 1844.—Baker, C. M. The trustee plan works. Mod. Hosp., 1941 57: No. 2, 77—Burnett, C. R. The ideal hospital trustee. Tr. Am. Hosp. Ass., 1939, 41: 446-51.—Cullman, H. S. A trustee has 2 responsibilities when it comes to legislation. Mod Hosp., 1936, 46: No. 6, 40.—Curtis, H. J. How a trustee can learn about hospitals through publications. Tr. Am. Hosp. Ass. 1938, 40: 458-61.—Davidson, S. G. The relation of the Board of trustees or the governing body to the superintendent and personnel of the hospital. Ibid., 1928, 30: 416-25.— Doane, J. C. Ten commandments for trustees. Mod. Hosp., 1940, 55: No. 5, 82.—Dressier. Die Krankenhausverwaltung HOSPITAL ADMINISTRATION 815 HOSPITAL ADMINISTRATION und der Betriebsrat. Zschr. ges. Krankenhauswes., 1929, 25: 703-8.—Emch, A.F. The Chicago Hospital Council. Hospitals, 1938, 12: No. 2. 58-60.—Flexner, A. ln praise of the trustee. Mod. Hosp., 1938, 51: No. 3, 60.—Foley, M. O. How hospital trustees can keep abreast with the advances in hospital adminis- tration. Bull. Am. Coll. Surgeons, 1933, 17: 58.—Germany, E. B. How a trustee can learn about his own hospital. Tr. Am. Hosp. Ass., 1938, 40: 455-8.—Gutachter-Ausschuss fur das offentliche Krankenhauswesen. Zschr. ges. Kranken- hauswes., 1926, 22: 289; 539.—Hugo, von. Der Gutachter- ausschuss fiir das offentliche Krankenhauswesen. Zschr. Krankenanst., 1925, 21: 329-33. —---- Kerschensteiner & Plank. Gutachterausschuss fiir das offentliche Krankenhaus- wesen. Zschr. ges. Krankenhauswes., _ 1935, 193-212.— Jackson, S M. The role of the trustee in modern hospital administration. Tr. Am. Hosp. Ass., 1928, 30: 408-11 — Jackson, W. H. Educating the trustee; his is the final responsi- bility. Mod. Hosp., 1941, 57: No. 6, 74—Jennings, F. E. The hospital trustee and his responsibility. Hospitals, 1936, 10: No. 2, 9-11.—MacLean, B. C. Administrative tact and trusteeship. Mod. Hosp., 1935, 45: No. 5, 69.—Manheimer, S. The new trustee needs help. Ibid., 1942, 58: No. 3, 84.— Matthews, L. I. How shall the hospital trustee acquire the necessary knowledge to properly discharge his responsibility? Hospitals, 1936, 10: 62-5.—New (The) trustee, by A Trustee. Ibid., 1942, 16: No. 2, 69.—Pratt, O. G. Organizing an ideal hospital board. Ibid., 1941, 15: No. 3, 43.—Rappleye (Dr) named Commissioner of hospitals. Ibid., 1940, 14: No. 11, 27.—Sloan, R. P. The selection of trustees. Tr. Am, Hosp. Ass., 1939, 41: 442-6.------Trustees, interpreters. Mod. Hosp., 1941, 56: 74-6.—Smith, G. S. The case for a National Hospitals Board. Lancet, Lond., 1941, 2: 109-11.—Stewart, S. Education for hospital trustees. Hospitals, 1941, 15: No. 5, 28-30.—Thornton, E. N., Levin, J. J.. & Foster, G. Report of Transvaal Hospital Commission of 1928. J. M. Ass. S. Africa, 1928. 2: 212-5. --- Heating, lighting, and ventilating. Huntington, D. L., Mew, W. M., & Billings, J. S. On heating and ventilation. 3 93p. 8°. Wash., 1878. Aschof. Warmewirtschaftliche Fragen. Zschr. ges. Kranken hauswes., 1926, 22: 513; 599—Bacon, A. S. Presbyterian hospital saves heating cost by switching to gas. Hospitals, 1937, 11: 63-5.—Bailey, E. P. Factors involved in the hospital fuel problem; oil. Tr. Am. Hosp. Ass., 1938, 40: 321-8 — Birk, C. Hygienische Entschlackung und Entaschung von Dampfkesselanlagen. Zschr. ges. Krankenhauswes., 1930, 120-3.—Fichtl. Warmewirtschaftliche Gesichtspunkte bei Anlage und beim Betrieb von Krankenanstalten. Ibid., 1926, 22: 79-82. ------ Zur Frage der Warme- und Energiewirt- schaft in Krankenanstalten. Ibid., 1929, 25: 531-3.—Gehren- beck, K. Heizung und Luftung im Krankenhaus. Gesundh. Ingenieur, 1937, 60: 33-9.—Graves, F. Heat, light, food, effort saved by 7 o'clock routine; 153-bed general hospital finds everyone pleased with practice of not disturbing patients until day nurses report. Hosp. Management, 1934, 37: 33.— Heizung (Die) im Krankenhaus. Schweiz. med. Wschr., 1939, 69: 960.—Littell, H. L. Factors involved in the hospital fuel problem; hard coal. Tr. Am. Hosp. Ass., 1938, 40: 334-44 — Moser, P. Ueber den Warmeverbrauch von Krankenhausern. Gesundh. Ingenieur, 1938, 61: OGo-7.—Naeslund, C. [Heating and ventilation of hospitals] Hygiea, Stockh., 1932, 94: 117- 51.—Neumann, O. Praktk-ch durchfuhrbare Versuche zur Ermittlung des wirtschaftlichsten Jiiennstoffs in Dampfkessel- anlagen. Zschr. ges. Krankenhauswes., 1927, 23: 402-7.— Pesterfield, C. H. Firing technics. Mod. Hosp., 1940, 55: 82.—Reed, C. A. Factors involved in the hospital fuel problem; soft or bituminous coal. Tr. Am. Hosp. Ass., 1938, 40: 328- 34.------ Bituminous coal in the American hospitals. Hospitals, 1939, 13: No. 2, 103-5.—Roach, S. F., Dubin, M. [et al.] Report of the Committee on the Study of Fuel and Heating Equipment, 1936. Tr. Am. Hosp. Ass., 1936, 38: 212- 26.—Schmidt, O. Heizung und Luftung in Krankenhausern. Gesundh. Ingenieur, 1936, 59: 332-5.—Schuize, A. Die Bedeutung der Warme- und Energiewirtschaft im Krankenhaus. Zschr. ges. Krankenhauswes., 1928, 24: 600-7.—Spillhagen, W. Die Wiirmeversorgung eines Krankenhauses. Gesundh. Ingenieur, 1939, 62: 453-8.—Yerbury, F. R. A treatise on panel heating for hospitals Tr. Am. Hosp. Ass., 1939, 41: 577-84. Also Hospitals, 1940, 14: No. 2, 65-7. --- Housekeeping. Dungan, D. Hospital housekeeping. 54p. 16? [Stamf., Conn., 1936] Hurst, N. P. Hospital housekeeping and sanitation. 155p. 16? S. Louis, 1926- Anderson, M. B. Making housekeeping wheels go round. Mod. Hosp., 1937, 48: No. 4, 88-90.—Atkerson, E. W. Modern dishwashing. Hospitals, 1938, 12: No. 11, 120-4—Browne, R. W. Conservation of hospital linen. Med. Bull. Veterans Admin., 1937-38, 14: 47.—Dungan, D. L. House manage- ment. Bull. Am. Coll. Surgeons, 1939, 24: 222—Fairburn, D. C. Hospital bouquets. Mod. Hosp., 1936, 47: No. 5, 40-3.—Heitman, S. Cooperation between housekeeping de- partment and other hospital departments. Hospitals, 1941, nnw+Xll 114-6--Joh"s°n. N. R. Cleaning agents; what and how to buy. Tr. Am. Hosp. Ass., 1937, 39: 798-806.—Kelley, l. V. Caring for a patient's personal belongings. In her Textb. Nurs. Techn., 4. ed., Phila., 1940- 38.—Koyen, H. The speci- fication and purchase of institutional linen. In Hosp. Admin. & Urg (Hosp. Management) Chic, 1942, 60.—LaBelle, A M Housekeeping procedures. Mod. Hosp., 1942, 58: No 3 94 — MacFarland, J. L. An opportunity for science; housekeeping in the hospitals. Hospitals, 1937, 11: 53-7.—Moncrieff. L. C. t lower arrangements in Greenwich hospital. Ibid., 1938 12- No. 6, 59.—N. Betriffs Bettenbelegung in grosseren Kranken- anstalten. Zschr. ges. Krankenhauswes., 1938, 60.—Newton, «*• '• System in handling linen. Mod. Hosp., 1937, 48: No. 1, 9o:—Ray, V. H. Centralized dishwashing wins approval. Ibid 92-8.—Selection (The) purchase and care of hospital blankets. In Hosp. Admin. & Org. (Hosp. Management) Chic, 1942, 58.—Sellin, von. Wolldecken und ihre Behand- lung. Zschr. ges. Krankenhauswes., 1928, 24: 99-102.— Sister Joan of Arc. Hospital housekeeping. Hosp. Progr., 1940, 21: 82-91.—Sperling, R. H. Formula for mattress care. Mod. Hosp., 1940, 54: No. 6, 90.—Spry, C. Flowers for the hospital. Ibid., 1938, 50: No. 6, 90.—Walsh, W. H. De- centralized services in large hospitals: food distribution, laun- dry service, linen, and bedding. Tr. Am. Hosp. Ass., 1931, 32: 591-603. ---- Income. See also subheading Fund and endowment. Bartine, O. H. Supplementary revenue; subsidies, gifts, donations, endowments, and other sources of financial support. Hospitals, 1941, 15: No. 12, 52-5. Also Bull. Am. Coll. Surgeons, 1942, 27: 49-51. Also Connecticut M. J., 1942, 6: 17-20.—Hudgens, R. New sources of income. Mod. Hosp., 1942, 58: 65.—Report of the Committee on hospital income and bed occupancy. Tr. Am. Hosp. Ass., 1933, 35: 176-84.— Slover W. P. Increasing hospital revenue. Hospitals, 1938, 12: No. 6, 49-51. ------ New sources of income. Mod. Hosp., 1938, 50: 48.—Smith, C. F. The hospital income; endowments, gifts, donations. Hospitals, 1936, 10: No. 4, 75-8.—Weber, J. J., Calvin, A. M. [et al.] Report of the Committee on Hospital Income and Bed Occupancy, 1937. Tr. Am. Hosp. Ass., 1937, 39: 68-73. ---- Information. Hartman, G. Development of sources of hospital informa- tion. Puerto Rico Health Bull., 1940, 4: 380-9.— Roszel, I. M. Management of the front office and information service. Hospitals, 1939, 13: No. 6, 48-50. ---- Insurance. Douthit, V. L. What's in your fire insurance policy? Mod. Hosp., 1936, 46: No. 6, 57-9.—Ehrenberg, K. Werkerhaltungs- versicherung, ein Erfordernis der Planwirtschaft im Kranken- hauswesen. Zschr. ges. Krankenhauswes., 1928, 24: 72—4.— Field, A. H. Life insurance endowments for hospitals. Tr. Am. Hosp. Ass., 1928, 30: 411-6.—Hospitals exempted from unemployment insurance act. Canad. M. Ass. J., 1940, 43: 383.—Insurance outline for hospitals. In Hosp. Yearb., 1941, 19: 1016.—Meyer, A. C, & Erikson, C. A. Hospital fire insurance should be reconsidered annually. Mod. Hosp., 1933, 41: 41-3.—Prevost, H. A. Is your hospital protected in suits for damages? many possible sources of attack on hos- pitals, worthy or dishonest, make this subject one for full consideration, says this writer. Hosp. Management, 1933, 35: 21.—Rouse, M. K. How fire insurance rates for hospitals are made. Hospitals, 1941, 15: No. 2, 49-51.—Wood, G. U. Hospital liability insurance. Mod. Hosp., 1938, 51: No. 5, 73. ---- Inventory. Church, R. E. How to take a usage inventory. Mod. Hosp., 1941, 57: No. 5, 94.—Nichols, L. H. Saving money in hospital inventories. In Hosp. Admin. & Org. (Hosp. Manage- ment) Chic, 1942, 74-6.—Pratt, C. C. Inventory control of purchases. Hospitals, 1941, 15: No. 11, 89. ---- Kitchen. Broihan. Die Buchfiihrung im Kuchenbetriebe des Kran- kenhauses und deren richtige Gestaltung. Zschr. ges. Kranken- hauswes., 1937, 343-5.—Hunzicker, B., & Bacon, A. S. Com- parison of various types of fuel for hospital kitchens. Hos- pitals, 1937, 11: No. 11, 97.—Kitchen ills and cures. Mod. Hosp., 1938, 50: No. 4, 67.—Klapp, O. Temperatur und Warme in der elektrischen Grosskiiche. Zschr. ges. Kranken- hauswes., 1937, 167-9.—Opitz, H. Luftung von Kranken- hauskochkuchen. Ibid., 1939, 261.—Pick. Der Kranken- hausleiter als Kiichendirigent; Wissenswertes iiber die Ein- richtungen in neuzeitlichen Kiichen von Krankenanstalten. Ibid., 1929, 25: 129-33.—Schilling. Die Zubereitung des KafTeegetranks mittels Quieta-Schwimmsieb. Ibid., 70.— Setz, M. Die Krankenhaus-Grosskuche. Gesundh. Ingenieur, 1936, 59: 669-75.—Soos, A. Betrachungen uber Organisations- formen der Krankenhausgrosskuchen. Zschr. ges. Kranken- hauswes., 1934, 149-52.—Weinstock, P. Welche Bedeutung hat die Krankenhauskiiche in der Krankenhausverwaltung, HOSPITAL ADMINISTRATION 816 HOSPITAL ADMINISTRATION und welche Aufgaben erwachsen Wiische- und Wirtschafta- schwestern im Rahmen des Krankenhausbetriebes? Ibid., 1926, 22: 36 1 9.------Anstaltskuchenhetrieb. Ibid., 1928, 24: 275-S2.- Wiele, G. Ueber die Ejngliederung von Diiit- kuchen in die llauptkuchenbctriebe der Krankenhauser und iiber die Ausbildung von Hauptkiichenleiterinnen. Ibid., 1935, 540. ---- Laundry. Austin, L. C. Efficiency in a hospital laundry. Hospitals, 1936, 10: No. 9, 102-4.—Briinecker, K. Burnus ein zweck- miissiges, neuzeitliches Waschmittel. Zschr. ges. Kranken- hauswes., 1926, 22: 719.—Cooke, L. T. Linen control. Hos- pitals, 193S, 12: No. 8, 91-4.—Crowley, A. Problems involved in hospital linen service. Ibid., 1910, 14: No. 3, 128-36.— Dahl, C. M- Laundering 40,000 pieces daily. Hosp. Manage- ment, 1931, 31: 28-31.—Diehl. J. Die Wascherei im Kranken- haus. Zs.hr. ges. Krankenhauswes., 1930, 309.—Do 100 patients need a laundry? Hosp. Management, 1942, 53: 72-6.—Gabrielson, R. J. Arrangements for an efficient laundry. In Hosp. Yearb., 1941, 19: 992-4.—Gotz, G. Wasch- vorschrift in einer Heil- und Pflegeanstalt (L.) Zschr. ges. Krankenhauswes., 1937, 534-9.—Guthjahr, W. Praktische Anwendung neuzeitlicher Erfahrungen auf dem Gebiete der Wascherei. Ibid., 1936, 204-8.—Haeuen, R. van der. Dif Bedeutung des Sicherheitsmomentes fiir die Durchfiilirung der neueren Waschtechnik in der Anstaltswaschkiiche. Ibid., 1939, 449-53.—Hancock, E. J. How may a hospital superin- tendent check laundry operation? knowledge of detailed pro- cedures and of chemistry not necessary; these suggestions show simple but effective way. Hosp. Management, 1934, 38: 40-2. ------ Major considerations in operating the hospital laundry. Ibid., 1935, 39: 23-6.—Hard water and soap Hospitals, 1942, 16: 55.—Haunschild. G. Rentahilitats- berechnungen von Maschinenwaschereien in Anstalten der offentlichen Hand. Zschr. ges. Krankenhauswes., 1939, 343- 5.—Heeren, R. H., Bradley, L. A. & Taylor, E. Handling contaminated linen in the general laundry. Mod. Hosp., 1941, 57: No. 6, 52.—Hein, L. H. Linen control as seen by the laundry manager. Hosp. Management, 1940. 50: No. 6, 47-50.—Higgins, M. A., & Stanley, T. The hospital laundry Hosp. Progr., 1927, 8: 221-4.—Johnson. G. H. Checking linen and cotton goods. Mod. Hosp., 1936, 46: No. 5. 75.— Jurasz, A. Etwas zum Nachdenken im Waschoreifach! Zsehr. ges. Krankenhauswes., 193S, 516-9.—Kelm. L. A. laundering for convalescents; a different problem. Mod. Hosp., 1927 28: No. 6, 1 III. Kind, H. A. Leinen in der Anstaltswiischerei Zschr. ges. Krankenhauswes., 1935. 232-5.------Maschi- neuuasehereien und Krankenanstalten in Deutschland. Ibid., 1939, 56-9. ----— Die Wascherei im Krankenhaus. Ibid., 21 7--2 C —Ladd, F. C. Launch y management and linen control. Hospitals, 1941, 15: 69-77.- I.atcham, J. F. Facts from your laundry. lb d., No. 2, 116-20 - Mcl'arland, .1. L. Coopera- tion and science come to tlw ail of laundrvmanatrers. Ibid., 1936. 10: No. 9, 89-91.—Mack, P. B., Krawier. J. F.. A Cooper H. W. Laboratory control for institutional laundry. Ibid., 1911. 15: No. 7, 58-60.—Oehler, F. Gutezeichen fiir sachge- ina.-ses Waschen Zschr. ges. Krankenhauswes., 1938, 491.— O'Hahlon. G. Xhe hospital laundry problem from the ad- ministrator's viewpoint. Tr. Am. Hosp. Ass., 1938, 40: 351-6. Also Hospitals. 1938, 12: No. 11, 53-5.—Page, C. To conserve laundry equipment, mind those squeaks. Mod Hosp., 1942, 58: 78. ------& Page, M. G. Cutting laundrv costs. Ibid., 1938, 50: No. 6, 86.—Plaetke, W. Waschprozess der KrankMihiuswasche aus zellwollehaltigen Geweben bei Verwendung eines sauerstoffhaltigen Waschmittels. Zschr. ges. Krankenhauswes., 1936, 495-7.—Reinhard. W. A. The laundry problem in the hospital. Tr. Am. Hosp. Ass., 1933, 35: 387-92.—Research laboratory solving laundry problems of hospitals with new technique. Hosp. Management, 1942.;53: No. 3, 72-6.—Roach, S. F. How much is enough in hospital laundry service? Ibid., 1935, 40: 24. ------ A different viewpoint on the hospital laundry service problem. Hospitals, 1937, 11: No. 6, 108-11. ------ In the hospital laundry. Ibid., 1938, 12: No. 2, 108. ------ Linen and laundrv service. Bull. Am. Coll. Surgeons, 1939, 24: 222. ------ Efficiency of hospital laundry depends on proper care and supervision of equipment. Hosp. Management, 1941, 52: No. 5, 72.— Schmidt. E. Die Wascherei im Krankenhaus. Zschr. ges. Krankenhauswes., 1931, 118-21.—Science in the laundry. Hosp. Topics, 1942, 20: No. 4, 10-3—Sloan, R. P. Laundry in modern terms. Mod. Hosp., 1936, 48: No. 2, 75.—Stain removal in the hospital laundry. Hosp. Management, 1939, 48: No. 5, 53.—Uhl. Faserschonung in der Krankenhaus- wascherei. Zschr. ges. Krankenhauswes., 1936, 561. ------ Neuere Entwicklung auf dem Gebiete des Waschen. Ibid 1941, 37: 164-8.—Wacker. A. [Zur Frage der Spitalwusche Orsz. Kozegeszs. Int. kozl., 1934, 7: No. 33.—Walther. B. Zerstorungen an Krankenhauswasche und ihre Ursachen Zschr. ges. Kiankenhauswes., 1928, 24: 693-5.------Dei Einfluss harten Wasseis auf die Gewebebeschaffenheit. Ibid., 1929, 25: bb-9. Wirth. Wascherei und Waschverfahren Ibid., 1927, 23: 689. ----- Liability. Bed well, C. E. A. Hospital's liability for negligence of staff. Lancet, Lond., 1942, 1: 489.—Brosnan, L. J. Charitable hospital; liability for negligence of its physicians and nurses. N. York State .1. M., 1931, 31: 421. ------ Charitable hos- pitals; liability for suicide of patient. Ibid., 1934, 34: 942.— Charitable hospitals; liability for negligence of nurses. J. Am M. Ass., 1937, 108: 1463-Charitable hospitals; liability to pay patient for negligence of employee. Ibid., 1939, 112: 361.-—Charitable hospitals; liability for tort, when covered by insurance. Ibid., 1941, 116: 436.- Charitable hospitals; liability for burns caused by negligence of nurse employee Ibid., 117: 2003- Charitable hospitals; liability to pay pa- tients. Ibid., 2274.—Charitable hospitals; liability for injuries to special nurse employed by pay patient. Ibid., 1912, 118: 1399.—Charitable hospitals; liability for tort conditioned on liability for taxation. Ibid., 1515. -Corish, J. R. \\ hen is the private hospital liable for negligence of its nurses? Mod Hosp., 1933, 41: 71-4.—County not liable to pay patient for hospital nurses' neglect. Med. Rec, N. Y., 1942, 155: 114.— Dempsey, J. C. Legal responsibility for hospital management. Hosp. Progr., 1931. 12: 336-10.—Doctrine of exemption as influenced bv practical consideiations. Hospitals, l!H2, 16- No. 2, 78.—Domel, R. Beitrage zur Haftpflicht der Kranken- hauser. Zschr. ges. Krankenhauswes., 1932, 385.— Feder, J. L. Liability insurance for hospitals; some of the unusual require- ments. N. York Physician, 1935, 4: No. 2, 17; 22.—Filing of hospital hen for services. Med. Hoc, N. Y., 1942, 155: 36.— Governmental hospital; liability to pay patient. .1. \m M Ass., 1941, 117: 2273.—Haftung und Rechtsfolgen bei' Un- fallen in arztlichen Praxisraumen. Deut. med. Wschr., 1941, 67: 45.—Henninger. Die Haftpflichte der Krankenanstalten! Zschr. ges. Krankenhauswes., 1935, 517-20.—Hospital associa- tions; liability to hospital that furnishes services to members I. Am. M. Ass., 1938, 110: 1866.—Hospital held not to practice medicine. Med. Rec, N. Y., 1942, 155: 152.—Hospital not liable for physician who has been carefully selected. Ibid., 1911, 154: 478.-- Hospitals for profit; duty of hospital to irra- tional patient. .1. Am. M. Ass., 1939, 112: 269.—Hospitals for profit; liability of owner of hospital for negligence of hospital nurses. Ibid., 1938, 110: 1782.—Hospitals for profit: when general allegations of negligence are sufficient. Ibid., 1941, 117: 1288.—Hospitals; liability for death of patient allegedly due to exposure to draft. Ibid., 116: 72.—Hospitals: liability for failure to place sideboards on patient's bed. Ibid., 1940 115: 1574; 1941, 117: 1210.—Hospitals; liability for injury to pay patient in county hospital. Ibid., 1936, 106: J22X.— Hospitals; liability for injury to patient from fright caused by defective electric fan. Ibid., 1939, 112: 2560.—Hospital's liability for negligence of staff. Lancet, Lond., 1942, 1: 4.57.— Hospitals; liability of charitable hospital for injury to pay patients. J. Am. M. Ass., 1939, 113: 1439.—Hospital's liability to paying patient. Med. Rec, N. Y., 1941, 154: 164.—Hospital's lien for services. Ibid., 1942, 155: 36 — Hospitals; nonprofit, hospital corporation not liable for negli- gence. J. Am. M. Ass., 1<»39, 113: 1763.—Hospitals; res ipsa 'oquitur as applied to ailment following childbirth. Ibid., 1941, 117: 1911. Joachim, M. A. Hospital lien laws. Hos- pitals, 1940, 14: No. 8, 29-36.—Liability for failure to adminis- ter medicines. Ibid., 1942, 16: 89.—Liability for negligence in maintaining premises. Ibid., 90.—Liability of hospital associa- tion for acts of dentist employee. J. Am. Dent. Ass., 1942, 29: 875.—Liability of hospital for improper treatment by layman, J. Am. M. Ass., 1938, 111: 1793.—Liability of hospital for negligence of nurse. N. York State J. M., 1940, 40: 1687 — Liability of nonprofit association. Hospitals, 1942, 16: 89.— Malpractice: liability of hospital association as affected bv judgment for professional employee. J. Am. M. Ass., 1940, 115: 1575.—Malpractice; liability of hospital for negligent acts of nurse during operation. Ibid., 1942, 118: 1242.— Malpractice; negligence of hospital not provable by lay testi- mony. Ibid., 1937, 108: 422.—Medico-legal abstracts; degree of care to be exercised by a hospital. Ibid., 109: 983.—Metzger, G. Liability of public charitable hospitals under the law of Ohio. J. Med., Cincin., 1937-38, 18: 339.—Negligence of Imunicipal] governmental agency. Hospitals, 1942, 16: No. 5, 89.—Owen, J. F. Hospitals; a nurse is not liable for injury caused by executing orders of a physician unless it is apparent that, injury would result; where a nuiM- is not liable for injury to the patient the hospital cannot be held liable as her employer. North Carolina M. J., 1942, 3: 13.- Pollet, L. Responsabilite administrative ou medicale dans la pratique m6dicale hospita- here. Ann. med. leg., 1938, 18: 6 13-9.-Recent legal decisions important to hospitals; judgment in favor of charitable in- stitution reversed by Supreme Court; [Florida,]; clinic held liableifor injury to patient from fall [Alabama] Hospitals 1941, 15: No. 3 81-3.—Report to the Council on Government relations relative to lien laws. Ibid., 1939, 13: No 12 84-9.— SchI tiger, M. Aufsichtspflicht in Krankenanstalten. Med. Welt. 1939, 13: 373-5.—Sieben. Ordnungsmiissige Personal- aufsicht als Sorgfaltspflicht gegen Haftungsanspruche. Zschr. ges. Krankenhauswes., 1936, 170-2.------Haftungss ausschluss durch hohere Gewalt und koiikuirierendes Ver- schulden. Ibid., 1937, 430-3.—Spencer, W. H. Legal aspect- ot ho,-pital administration. Hospitals, 1939, 13: No 11,39s 45.—Stephens, H. M. The legal responsibility of hospital- Canada Lancet Pract., 1926, 27: 87-108.—Suit by visitor to recover for personal injuries sustained on hospital premises, Hospitals, 1942, 16: No. 5, 89.—Sweet, J. G. Custodial liability in California. Ibid., 1941, 15: No. 8, 79-87.—Walter, rAo ™ ™Sp.lta! lle? laws' Tr- Am- HosP- Ass., 1933, 35: btuWU.—Whether hospital can claim liena upon recoveries HOSPITAL ADMINISTRATION 817 HOSPITAL ADMINISTRATION for injuries. Hospitals, 1941, 15: No. 12, 19.—Wolff, J. Die Haftung der Krankenanstalten. Zschr. ges. Krankenhauswes., 1935, 509-17. ■---- medical. Bay, E. B. Medical administration of teaching hospitals. 8? Chic. [1931] Black, B. W. Medical policies and procedures for the resident staff of the Alameda County hospitals and clinics. 236p. 12? [Berkeley, Calif., 1936] LaRoque, G. P. Professional duties and government for the care of the sick in hospitals. 44p. 8? [Richmond, 1917] Baldassari, L. Per la preparazione del personale medico direttivo degli ospedali. Osp. maggiore, Milano, 1933, -21: 307.—Bremer, F. W. Sorgen des Krankenhausarztes. Ver- trauensarzt, 1937, 5: 97-102.—Brinker, W. Der Verwaltungs- betrieb im Krankenhaus vom Standpunkt des Arztes aus; Erwiderung. Zschr. ges. Krankenhauswes., 1941, 37: 71-3.— Coker, G. N. Will the hospitals run the physicians, or will the physicians run the hospitals? J. M. Ass. Georgia, 1938, 27: 359.—Deschwanden, G von. Was muss der leitende Arzt eines mittelgrossen Krankenhauses wissen? Nosokomeion, Stuttg., 1934, 5: 8-10.—Dudding, J. S. The administration of a hospital ward. J. R, Nav. M. Serv., 1930, 16: 251-6.— Giddings, E., & Cordover, H. Hospital administration as a medical specialty. Hospitals, 1937, 11: 24-9.—Mansholt, W. H. The physician as hospital director. Nosokomeion, Stuttg., 1931, 2: 184-204.—Jahn, D. Die medizinische Klinik in Freiburg im arztlichen Betrieb. Zschr. ges. Krankenhauswes., 1936, 304-6.—Karg, N. Krankenhauswirtschaftslehre fiir Studierende der Medizin. Ibid., 1934, 337-41.—Kretschmer, H. L. The medical specialities boards and the hospital. Hosp. Progr., 1937, 18: 299-301.—Lukin, N. The hospital situation; how the closed principle in hospital policies lowers the standard of the practice of medicine in a community. Med. Rev. of Rev., 1927, 33: 59-68.—Muller, B. W. Zu den Sorgen des Krankenhausarztes. Vertrauensarzt, 1937, 5: 175-8.— Westphal, K. Forderungen an eine neuzeitliche Ausgestaltung und Betriebsfuhrung der Krankenanstalten in arztlicher Hinsicht. Zschr. ges. Krankenhauswes., 1941, 37: 41-5. --- Methods. Alvaro, M. E. Organizacao scientifica do trabalho nos hospitaes. Fol. med., Rio, 1936, 17: 566-8.—Anderson, V. M. The president's address. Hospitals, 1936, 10: No. 6, 103-5 — Babcock, W. L. Report of committee on hospital organization and management (1930) Tr. Am. Hosp. Ass., 1931, 32: 30- 40 —Ballmann, E. Ueber Krankenhausplanwirtschaft. Zschr. ges. Krankenhauswes., 1928, 24: 41-4.—Berkowitz, M. E. Further notes on property location records. Hosp. News, Wash 1938, 5: No. 9, 21-4.—Black, B. W. Organization of hospitals. Hospitals, 1936, 10: No. 1, 72-4— Bluestone, E. M. Breakfast conference, sponsored by the American College of Hospital Administrators in co-operation with the American College of Surgeons. Bull. Am. Coll. Surgeons, 1942, 27: 71 — Brisbane, R. D. Non-profit hospital has many advantages. Hospitals, 1937, 11: No. 4, 120-2.—Brown, N. G. Trends in hospital management from the nurse's standpoint. Hosp. Management, 1935, 39: 46.—Buerki, R. C, Agnew, G. H. [et al] Council on Professional Practice, annual report 1938. Tr. Am. Hosp. Ass., 1938, 40: 62.—Butler, S. L. The technical organization of the administration and management in hospitals. Nosokomeion, Stuttg., 1931, 2: 803-10—CaldwelL B. W. Future trends in hospital management and service. Bull. Am. Coll. Surgeons, 1935, 19: 4-7.—Cederstrom, H. Plan wirtschaft im Krankenhauswesen. Zschr. ges. Krankenhauswes., 1936, 325-9 —Centralized control eliminates duplication in services. Hosp. Management, 1941, 52: No. 4, 29—Changing trends ui hospital field outlined at Pennsylvania meeting. Ibid., 1940, 49: No 5 19.—Council on administrative practice arranges for 2 institutes. Hospitals, 1941, 15: No. 2, 86.-Craig, G. Im- provements of hospitals. J. Coll. Surgeons Australasia, 1928, 1: 39-42.—Cullman, H. S. Application of business principles in hospital administration. BuU. Am. Coll. Surgeons, 1931, 15: 44-8—Current hospital thought; expressions of hospital boards and trustees, collected from 1938 reports and other sources. Hospitals, 1939, 13: No. 2, 73-5.—Davis, M. M., Bachmeyer, A. C. [et al.] Report of the Council on Community Relations and Administrative Practice, 1937. Tr. Am. Hosp Ass 1937J 39: 48-54.—Davis, M. M., Goldwater, S. S. let al.] Report of the Council on Community Relations and Adminis- trative Practice, 1936. Ibid., 1936, 38: 46-8—Delia Porta, M. Organizzazione amministrative dell'ospedale italiano. Noso- komeion, Stuttg., 1931, 2: 1032-50.—Dressier, O. Zur Frage der Rationalisierung im Krankenhaus,. Zschr ges. Kranken- hauswes., 1927, 23: 344-7.—Foley, M. O. If Dr MacEachern were in charge of a hospital in 1933—here are some of the things we would do and he believes that practically all of them are within the possibility of nearly every hospital superintendent. Hosip. Management, 1933, 35: 21—Four separate hospitals under one administration. Mod. Hosp., 1931, 37: 23-30, pt 2 — Frey, H. Standardisation und Selbstkonti olle der Verwaltung. Nosokomeion, Stuttg., 1933, 4: 41-58.—Gappa, J. Aufgaben 227475—vol. 7, 4th sebibs----52 der Krankenhausrevision. Zschr. ges. Krankenhauswes., 1930, 537-40.—Gehrenbeck, K. Forderungen an eine neuzeitliche Ausgestaltung und Betriebsfuhrung der Krankenanstalten in betnebstechnischer Hinsicht. Ibid., 1941, 37: 48-55.—Gold- water, S. S. The aims of the council on community relations and administrative practice. Tr. Am. Hosp. Ass., 1933, 35: 410-5. ------ The future of hospital administration. Hospi- tals, 1938, 12: No. 11, 15-7.—Groth. Aus der Organisation amerikanischcr Krankenhauser. Zschr. ges. Krankenhauswes., 1927, 23: 583-93.—Haberlin. Einige Bemerkungen zu einem rationellen Krankenhausbetrieb. Schweiz. med. Wschr., 1929, 59: 669-71.—Hausen, W. Statistik und Krankenhausver- waltung. Zschr. ges. Krankenhauswes., 1936, 309-12.—Hay- how, E. C. Modernization of patients' facilities requires detailed analysis. In Hosp. Admin. & Org. (Hosp. Management) Chic, 1942, 4-6.—Hermann. Der Schriftvcrkehr der Anstalten mit nicht vorgesetzten Behorden, Korperschaften des offentlichen Rechts u. dgl. Zschr. ges. Krankenhauswes., 1928, 24: 377.— Hospital plans and A. H. A., closer cooperation is forecast. Mod. Hosp., 1941, 56: No. 5, 70.—Joscphson, E. M. Approved hospital farce. In his Merchants in Med., N. Y., 1941, 143-5.— Khairallah, A. A. New private hospital in Beirut adopts American methods. Mod. Hosp., 1933, 40: 57-62.—Kunze, J. Forderungen an eine neuzeitliche Ausgestaltung und Betriebs- fuhrung der Krankenanstalten in wirtschaftlicher Hinsicht. Zschr. ges. Krankenhauswes., 1941, 37: 45-8.—Larsen, A. E. Central bureau relieves clinic case loads. Mod. Hosp., 1939, 52: No. 4, 66-9.—Lomas, A. I. Un ospedale destinato all'inse- gnamento sceglic un piano adeguato alle sue esigenze. Osp. maggiore, Milano, 1935, 23: 110-4.—Louros, N. Ueber die planwirtschaftliche Entwicklung des Krankenhauswesens in Griechcnland. Zschr. ges. Krankenhauswes., 1937, 549-51.— MacEachern, M. T. Changing trends in hospital administra- tion. Hospitals, 1940, 14: No. 10, 39-43.—MacLean, B. C, Anscombe, E. M. [et al.] Council on Administrative Practice, annual report 1938. Tr. Am. Hosp. Ass.. 19.38, 40: 58-61.— Manz, P. Organisation, Technik und Einrichtung im Kranken- haus. Nosokomeion, Stuttg., 1934, 5: 185-8.—Neff, R. E. Present trends in. hospital administration. Bull. Am. Coll. Surgeons, 1935, 19: 77-82. ------ Fundamental principles underlying efficient hospital administration. Hospitals, 1937, 11: No. 7, 85-8.—Nissel, W. Rationalisierung klinischer Be- triebe. Zschr. ges. Krankenhauswes., 1929, 25: 185-8.—Page, E. C. Hospital organization. Pennsylvania Health, 1942, 3: 33-5.—Plank. Planwirtschaft im Krankenhauswesen odor Deutsches Reichskrankenhaus. Zschr. ges. Krankenhauswes., 1941, 37: 1-5.—Poppe, F. Piano de racionamento para o hospital Miguel Pereira. Brasil med., 1940, 54: 393-7.— Pozzato, P. Note di tecnica ospedaliera. Osp. maggiore, Milano, 1938, 26: 468; 520; 552.—Pujatti, D. Intorno ad una nuova concozione sull'ordinamento degli ospedali. Igiene mod., 1937, 30: 145-51.—Raymond, R. H. Venture in hospital manage- ment and how it succeeded. Mod. Hosp., 1930, 34: 73-6.— Ronzani, E. Nuova era ospedaliera. Osp. maggiore, Milano, 1938, 26: 463-7.—Rosenwald, J. Hospitals from a business man's point of view. Tr. Am. Hosp. Ass., 1931, 32: 106-11. A business man thinks about hospitals. Bull. Am. Hosp. Ass., 1935, 9: 9-14. Also Hosp. Management, 1935, 39: 20.—Riickmann. Vorteile der Statistik im praktischen Ver- waltungs- und Betriebsdienst. Zschr. ges. Krankenhauswes., 1928, 24: 369-72.—Scheidt, A. H. Hospital business methods; a critical analysis. Bull. Am. Coll. Surgeons, 1942, 27: 32.— Schuize, H. GroszstadtischeKrankenanstaltswirtschaft. Zschr. ges. Krankenhauswes., 1936, 53-5.—Sloan, R. P. A hospital gets down to business. Mod. Hosp., 1936, 46: No. 5, 42-6.— Smelzer, D. C. Business administration of the hospital. Hospitals, 1936, 10: No. 2, 76-9.—Sollazzo, G. Nuovi indirizzi della tecnica ospedaliera moderna. Rass. internaz. clin. ter., 1935, 16: 1091; 1124.—Staples, P. C. Business and Blue Cross plans. Hospitals, 1941, 15: No. 11, 49-52.—Stephenson, A. G. Hospital administration abroad. Med. J. Australia, 1933, 2: 653-8.—Swern, P. W. Visualize the hospital of the future in modernization plans. In Hosp. Admin. & Org. (Hosp. Manage- ment) Chic, 1942, 1-3.—Urwick, L. Rationalization and hospital administration. Nosokomeion, Stuttg., 1931, 2: 789- 802.—Vergleichende Uebersicht iiber die Betriebsergebnisse und Betriebsverhaltnisse von 58 Krankenanstalten und Heilstatten. Zschr. Krankenanst., 1912, 8: 345; passim.—Verreault, G. Business administration in sisters' hospitals.' Hosp. Progr., 1932,' 13: 222-4.—Ways (The) of our hospitals. Med. Times, Lond., 1937, 65: 3.—Yaw, R. For efficiency use modern busi- ness forms. Mod. Hosp., 1941, 57: No. 5, 55.—Zappe. Beitrag zur neuzeitlichen Wirtschaftsfuhrung im Krankenhaus. Zschr. ges. Krankenhauswes., 1937, 269.—Zeitler, R. Planwirtschaft im Krankenhauswesen. Ibid., 1934, 73-5. ---- Plant maintenance. Amberg, R. Wax and soap. Hospitals, 1938, 12: No. 12, 97-9.—Anscombe, E. M., Bishop, H. E. [et al.] Report of the Committee on the Care of Walls and Floors, 1937. Tr. Am. Hosp. Ass., 1937, 39: 194-276.—Arrowsmith, L. M., Gould, C. E. [et al.) Report of the Committee on Standardization and Simplification of Hospital Furnishings, Supplies, and Equip- ment, 1937. Ibid., 190-4.—Baker, C. T. These hospital plants still need a doctor. Hosp. Management, 1940, 50: No. 4, 62-4 —Bishop, H. E. A system for checking the maintenance of equipment. Ibid., 1936, 41: 17-9. ------ Hockett, A. J., & Gammill, L. C. Report of the Committee on the Care of Walls HOSPITAL ADMINISTRATION 818 HOSPITAL ADMINISTRATION and Floors, 1936. Tr. Am. Hosp. Ass., 1936, 38: 226-39.— Hurt. M. AU >"t for summer. Mod. Hosp., 1041, 56: No. 4, 98.—Champion. W. J. Maintenance painting in the hospital. Hospital--. 1937. 11: 92-4.- Crews, J. M. Guide to plumbing maintenance. Mod. Hosp., 1940, 51: No. 5, 92. ■—---- Painting for preservation and sanitation. Ibid., 1941, 57: No. 4, 91- Deacon. J. G. Floor maintenance. Hospitals, 1938, 12: No. (>, 41. Do hospitals pay too much for heat, steam and power? Mil. Hosp., 1933, 41: 81-3.—Dreyer. ErhMning der Wirtsi baft Inhkeit der elektrischen Leistung in Krankenhausern, Zschr. ges. Krankenhauswes., 1936, 284.—Enderlein, W. Verstopfungen von Abwasserlcitungen im Anstaltsbetriebe. Ibid., 1929, 25: 38— Ewert, H. Betriebstechnische Erlebnissc aus dem Dampfkessel- und Maschinenhaus. Ibid., 1936, 353.—Fichtl. Zur Frage der Warme- und Energiewirtschaft in Kiankenanstalten. Gesundh. Ingenieur, 1929, 52: 753.— Greene. E. A. Hospital maintenance supervision. Hospitals, 1938. 12: No. 4, 84-7.—Gronow. W. K. von. Die neuestc Entwicklung des chemischen I\ lein-Loschgerates in seiner Hedetitung fur offentliche Krankenanstalten. Zschr. ges. hrank< nhauswes., 1926, 22: 433-5.—Hannaford, H. E. Re- modeling the hospital to meet today's requirements. Mod. Hosp., 1933, 41: 55-S. — Hinenburg, M. When winter comes. Ibid., 1941, 57: No. 5, 67.—Hospital patients endangered by Kansas Cit\ power st i ike. Hosp. Management, 1941, 52: No. 5,3). Ingvar S. [Necessit\ ofan internal hospital renova- tion] Sven. lak. tidn, 1937, 34: 1433-51.—Kingsford, E. Maintenance of windows. Mod. Hosp., 1941, 57: No. 5, 90.— Kinsey, R. D. Conservation of supplies and preservation of propei ty. Hosp. News, Wash., 1935, 10: 9-24. --Mac Karhern, M. T. The administrative viewpoint of the mechanical divi- sions of hospital operation. Tr. Am. Hosp. Ass.. 1936, 38: 716-22.- McNulty, J. J. Maintenance ,,f the hospital's assets. Ho-p. 1'rogr., 1940, 21: 415.--Miner. E. F. Records of mechanical operations. Hospitals, 1940, 14: No. 5, 81-91.— Mooney. F. 1). The mechanical division of hosnital operation as it relate- to the administrator's problem. Tr. Am. Hosp. Ass., 193S, 40: 344-51. Also Hospitals, 1938, 12: No. 10, 67-70.—Munger. C.W. &Stacey.J. M. We do our remodeling one step at a time. Mod. Hosp., 1940, 54: No. 5, 52-5.— Neergaard, C. F. Reconditioning and remodeling hospitals and equipment. Tr. Am. Hosp. Ass., 1933, 35: 720-6. Engineering in the hospital of tomorrow. Tr. Am. Soc. Heat. Ventil. Engin., 1934, 40: 303-18. ------- Checking the operating and maintenance cost of the mechanical division. Tr. Am. Hosp. Ass., 1937, 39: 787-93. Also Hospitals, 1937, 11: No. 11, 79-82.—Overton, W. J. Suggestions on plant maintenance for the hospital engineer; inspection, repair, replacement, determination whether equipment is operating at its maximum efficiency, aid in keeping hospital's cost low. Hosp. Management, 1935, 39: No. 4, 15; 35.—Repair and maintenance order P-22 replaced bv preference rating order P-100. Hos-'itals, 1942, 16: No. 2. 73.-Report of the Commit- tee on hospital planning and equipment; reconditioning and remodeling hospitals and equipment. Tr. Am. Hosp Ass., 1933. 35: 70.3-20.- Report of the Committee on simplification and standardization of furnishings, supplies, and equipment, with summary of commodities standardized. Ibid., 141-62.— Richardson, D. L. Intern and nurse aid in conservation of hospital equipment and supplies. Hospitals, 1941, 15: 24.— Roach. S. F.. & Mays. J. R. Mechanical Division of Hospital operation; disturbing conditions, corrective procedure. Tr. Am. Hosp. Ass., 1937, 39: 761-87.—Sloan, R. P. Community spirit at Concord. Mod. Hosp., 1940, 55: No. 3, 68-71.— Smelzer, D. C. Cat and preservation of portable equipment in tlo- hospital. Tr. Am. Hosp. Ass., 1936, 38: 696-9 — Stephenson, A. G. Going modern. Mod. Hosn., 1936, 47: No. 2, 46-6.—Sfudebaker, G. R. Preparing the plant for winter. Ibid., 19-11, 57: 59—Swain. P. W. How to get a dollar s worth out of the power dollar. Tr. Am. Hosp. Ass., 1936, 38: 709-15. ------- Do we take our power plant problems seriously, and why? Ibid , 1939, 41: 556-68.—Til lotson, D. The back of the house; its function and importance; the power house, the laundry, housekeeping, maintenance and repairs. Ibid., 1928, 30: 479-86—Wilinsky, C. F. Plant maintenance. Bull. Am. Hosp. Ass., 1934, 8: 86-97.—Wilson, L. R. Main- tenance of floors, walls, and ceilings. Hospitals, 1940, 14: No. 5. 96-100. ----- Policies. Binner, M. W. Is your hospital run according to constitu- tion, by-laws'.' expei ience of this institution in revising by-laws undoubtedly helpful to many others. Hosp. Management, 1934, 37: 32.—Carter, F. G. Institutional policies. Hospitals, 1940, 14: No. 8, 13 7 — Christian H. A. Some features in hospital administration from the viewpoint of a clinician Boston M. cV S. J., 1926, 194: 668-72.—Dressier, O.. & von Sellin, R. Y\ as miissen Verwaltung und Wirtschaft im Kranken- haus zur richtigen psychischen Einstellung des Kranken leisten? Nosokomeion. Stuttg., 1930, 1: 463-88.—Erb, A. H. Harmony and co-operation in the hospital. Colorado M., 1936, 33: 274-80.—Goldwater, S. S. The correction by administrative methods of iinde-irable mental states in hospital patients Nosokomeion. Stuttg.. 1930, 1: 70-8. ------- Assignment for the hospital of the future. Mod. Hosp., 1938, 51: No. 3, 50-3.— Gomez de Rosas, N. Principios fundamentales de toda organi- zaci6n hospitalaria. Rev. mid. cubana, 1941, 52: 444-7.__ Hamilton, S. How Harper Hospital, Detroit, centers its entire service on patient. Hosp. Management, 1930, 29: 30-5. Hoffmann. W. Was wollen wir im Krankenhaus nicht nn In haben? Nosokomeion, Stuttg., 1935, 6: 132-0.—Hospital executives cite Don'ts based on experience; many valuable pointers offered to Australian hospital board in New South Wales Community Hospital competition. Hosp. Management 1934, 38: No. 6, 20-4.—Hospital policies in post-war period! Hospitals, 1942, 16: No. 2, do.-Hurley, V. An outline of ft suggested policy for tin College of Surgeons of Australasia for the improvement of liosritals. J. Coll. Surgeons Australasia, 1928,1:43 52.--Kerr, Let;. Humanizing our hospitals Med Rec, N. V., 1940, 152: 125- 8. Lutes. J. I). Pitt mi' t lie hospi- tal to tli<' times. Clin. M. .t S., 1932, .'*!): Si IS 71. Mussey, A., & Ferguson, J. Hospital policy jn relation to preventive medi- cine. Pub. Health, Lond., 1937 3S, 51: 235 13.- -Menzie.s, F Hospital policy. Brit. M. J , 19-11, 2: 666. -Munger, C W Patients first. Mod. Hosp., 1937, 48: 73-5.—Neff, R. E. Hospital management should be on a professional plane. Ibid., 1934, 42: 71-4.—Rimbaud, L., & Romeu, J. La politique hospitalise des hospices de Montpellier; rapport pr£sent6 au Congres dalliance et d'hygiene sociales (Montpellier, 29-30-31 octobre 1937) Montpellier med., 1938, 3. ser., 13: 91-127.— Rogers. M. A. Philanthropy for hospitals. Hospitals, 1941, 15: No. 6, 53.—Ro-ner, O. S. No place for politics. Mod Hosp., 1941, 57: 77.—Salvisberg, O. R. Grundlagen der Gestaltung im Krankenhaus. Nosokomeion, Stuttg., 1934, 5; 229-36.—Sieben. Gemeinschaftsarbeit im Krankciiliuus. Zschr. ges. Krankenhauswes., 1934, 269-72.—Sloan, R. V. Thereis unity at Jeanes, therefore strength. Mod. Hosp., 19.'i.">, 44: 62-6. - Soresi, A. L. Humanizing the City hospitals Med. Rec, N. Y., 1934, 139: 565-70.—Wilinsky, C. F. Busi- ness orincioles in hospital management. Hospitals, 1940, 14- No. 2. 53-7. ---- Problems. Agnew, G. H. Problems of administration and manage- ment in hos"itals. Nosokomeion, Stuttg., 1931, 2: 723-39^ — Alter. Gemeinsame Sitzung der Ausschusse; Bau, Einrichtung und Technik, Leistung am Kranken im Krankenhaus uml Krankenkost. Ibid., 1933, 4: 581-6.—Barrett, J. Hospital problems. Brit. M. J., 1935, 2: 485-90. Also S. Afr. M ,1 1936, 10: 349-57.—Bartesaghi, L. II problema dei vecchi osnedali nella nuova era ospitaliera. Osp. maggiore, Milano 1939, 27: 41-7.—Caldwell, B. W. Important legislative, preparedness, and emergency problems now facing hospitals. Bull. Am. Coll. Surgeons, 1942, 27: 25.—Daley, W. A. Problems in hospital administration arising out of the local government act, 1929. Proc. R. Soc. M., Lond., 1934, 27: 1445-50.— Davis, R. B. Comments upon current subjects in the hospital magazines of today. South. M. & S., 1940, 102: 259.—Dittrich, L. H. More honorable mention entries in the hospital don'ts contest; additional suggestions which may contain just the answer you want to some particularly puzzling and bothersome difficulty. Hosp. Management, 1935, 39: No. 4, 36-8 — Gail. F. B., Finney, J. M. T., jr [et al.] Problems pertaining to various phases of hospital administration in the large hospital. Bull. Am. Coll. Surgeons, 1940, 25: 93-7.—Golden, B. I. Management problems of small and moderate sized hospitals. Mod. Hosp., 1934, 43: 47-9.—Goldwater, S. S. Trampling on the rules. Ibid., 1931, 36: 68-72.—Gralla, R. Organisations- fragen in Sanatorien und Krankenanstalen. Zschr. ges. Krankenhauswes., 1935, 127-9.—Guthjahr. Zur Frage der Verwaltung der Krankenhauser. Ibid., 1927, 23: 41-6.— Hausen, W. Betriebswirtschaftliche Organisationsfrngen. Ibid., 1938, 293-9.—Heath, W. A. Maintaining hospital standards in war calls for extra vigilance; supplies, personnel, sound financial policy are chief points of problem. Hosp. Management, 1942, 53: No. 5, 19.—Johnson, H. H. 1 he mutual problems of medical practice and administration from the view- point of the attending staff. Tr. Am. Hosp. Ass., 1928, 30: 217-20.—Korach, A. Probleme des Krankenhauswesens unter besonderer Berucksichtigung der Berliner Verhaltnisse. Klin. Wschr., 1928, 7: 1698-704.—List, W. E. Hospitals day by day; some pointed paragraphs. Hospitals, 1938, 12: No. 11, 66.— Lopez Rovirosa, G. Problemas hospitalarios; autoridad de los directores; exactitud en las estadisticas. Arch, hosp., Habana, 1940, 11: 335-7.—MacEachern, M. T. Problems of hospital administration. Hosp. Progr., 1926, 7: 2-7.-------& Jolly, R. Round table on general hospital problems, October 2, 1936. Tr. Am. Hosp. Ass., 1936, 38: 827-46.—Mohr, E. F. H. Some hospital problems. S. Afr. M. J., 1940, 14: 218-22.--NIRA (The) as affecting hospitals, colleges, and other uon-coiiimen ial institutions. Bull. Am. Hosp. Ass., 1933, 7:'14-21.—Power, C. M. Some aspects of hospital management. Westminster Hosp. Rep., Lond., 1934, 22: 234-47.—Remy, C. E. A walk and talk through the hospital and its affairs with the .superin- tendent. Annual Rep. Minneapolis Con. Hosp., 1933, I: 28- 36.—Round table on small hospital problems, September 30, 1936. Tr. Am. Hosp. Ass., 1936, 38: 531-00.— Slimmon, J. B. The hospital, a business concern; are its selection problems similar to industry? Hospitals, 1940, 14: No. 10, 71-9.— Sloan, R. P. St John's is meeting its problems squarely. Mod. Ho.sp., 1935. 45: No. 5, 57-60.-—Topping, A. Some problems of host.ital administration. .1. R. San. Inst., 1938-39, 59: 690- 705. Warner, C. C. Problems of hospital business manage- ment. West Virginia M. J., 1931, 27: 536-9.—Wilson, L. R. Nurses, patients and hospital pocketbooks. Mod. Hosp., 1930, HOSPITAL ADMINISTRATION 819 HOSPITAL ADMINISTRATION 35: 67-70.—Woller, E. Gegenwartsfrag en des deutschen Krankenhauswesens. Zschr. ges. Krankenhauswes., 1939, 380-4. ------ Tagesfragen des Krankenhauswesens. Ibid., 505-8. ---- Protection of hospital. Air raid precautions. Connecticut M. J., 1942, 6: 199- 201.—Alter. Krankenhaus und Luftkrieg. Zschr. ges. Kran- kenhauswes., 1936, 254-6.—Bernecker, E. Safe and sane de- fense. Mod. Hosp., 1942, 58: No. 2, 46.—Blast protection for hospital windows. Brit. M. J., 1941, 1: 762.—Demuth, E. L. Practical suggestions for hospital defense. Mod. Hosp., 1942, 58: No. 2, 42-5.—Deutsches Reich. Richtlinien fur bauliche Luftschutzmassnahmen in Krankenhausern, Lazaretten, Heil- und Pflegeanstalten. Reichsgesundhbl., 1939, 14: 408-10 — Engelbach, A. G. Practical defense measures for the indi- vidual hospital. Hospitals, 1941, 15: No. 10, 37-40.—Hockett, A. J., Pratt, O. G. (et al.| Physical protection of hospitals; report of Committee on the Physical Protection of Hospitals. Ibid., 1942, 16: No. 2, 13-29.—Hospital equipment under War Damage Bill. Brit. M. J., 1941, 1: 465.—Lessons from London in regard to air raid protection. Mod. Hosp., 1942, 58: No. 3, 68.—Muntsch, O. Das Krankenhaus im Rahmen des zivilen Gas- und Luftschutzes. Zschr. ges. Kranken- hauswes., 1933, 14C-4.—Ninety eight per cent effective black- out held at West Suburban Hospital. Hosp. Management, 1942, 53: 17.—Popov. G. M. [Equipment of hospitals during conditions of air defense] Gig. san., Moskva, 1939, 4: No. 10, 20-6.—Protecting hospitals against war hazards. Hospitals, 1941, 15: No. 7, 74.—Protection for hospitals; official recom- mendations of the OCD. Hosp. Topics, 1942, 20: No. 2, 16-30.—Protection of building fabric, patients and personnel. Mod. Hosp., 1942, 58: No. 2. insert, 3.—Protection of hospitals against aerial attack (Germany) J. Am. M. Ass., 1939, 112: 1845.—Protective procedures for hospitals. Ibid., 1941, 117: 2078.—Sollazzo, G. La protezione degli ospedali contro gli attacchi aerei. Osp. maggiore, Milano, 1935, 23: 105-9.—■ Thomann, J. Der Schutz des Krankenhauses im Krieg und die Stellung der Zivilspitaler im passiven Luftschutz. Nosoko- meion, Stuttg., 1937, 8: 137.------La defence passive des fetablissements hospitaliers civils (hopitaux civils) Ibid., 1938, 9: 63-6.—Turner, J. Hospital protection. Hospitals, 1942, 16: No. 2, 35-42; No. 4, 69-77.—Walsh, W. H. Structural and other precautions against air raid risks in hospitals. Ibid., 1941, 15: No. 4, 35-41. ---- Publicity. Brief (A) history of National Hospital Day. Hosp. Manage- ment, 45: No. 4, 16-8.—Broadcasters tell how to plan success- ful radio program. In Hosp. Admin. & Org. (Hosp. Manage- ment) Chic, 1942, 93.—Celebrations at World's Fairs feature 1939 Hospital Day. Ibid., 97-101.—Del Castillo, L. G. The spoken work, radio talks. Bull. Am. Coll. Surgeons, 1942, 27: 68-70.—Dixon, E. An aspect of hospital publicity. Hosp. Progr., 1937, 18: 81.—Dunstan, E. M. Educational state- wide program won 1940 Hospital Day award for Texas. Hosp. Management, 1941, 52: No. 4, 14. ------ City-wide ob- servances offer many advantages. In Hosp. Admin. & Org. (Hosp. Management) Chic, 1942, 83. ------ Joint observ- ance of Hospital Day of great value to Dallas hospitals. Ibid., 84-6.—Eichenlaub, M. H. Features of the work of publicity committee of Pennsylvania. Hosp. Management, 1934, 37: 19. ------ Pennsylvania's hospital educational program. Tr. Am. Hosp. Ass., 1938, 40: 775-86.—Essay contest for students sponsored by New York hospitals. In Hosp. Admin. & Org. (Hosp. Management) Chic, 1942, 116.—Exhibits at 1939 expositions attract attention to hospitals. Hosp. Manage- ment, 1939, 47: No. 3, 20.—Foley, M. O. 1935 national hos- pital day meets biggest success in its history. Ibid., 1935, 39: 22; 38.—Fuller, W. The written word; newspaper publicity. Bull. Am. Coll. Surgeons, 1942, 27: 67.—Hahn, A. G., Arm- strong, L. M. [et al.] Report of the National Hospital Day Committee, 1936. Tr. Am. Hosp. Ass., 1936, 38: 94-9. ------ Report of the National Hospital Day Committee, 1937. Ibid., 1937, 39: 133-40.—Hickernell, L. N., & Bosquet, F. L. Prize-winning celebration offers ideas for 1939 observance. In Hosp. Admin. & Org. (Hosp. Management) Chic, 1942, 104-7.—Hicks, F. War emphasized hospital's importance in relation to community; National Hospital Day offers oppor- tunity to stress role. Hosp. Management, 1942, 53: No. 4, 13.—Historical (The) background of national hospital day. Ibid., 1936, 41: 23-42.—History (The) of national hospital day. Ibid., 1937, 43: No. 4, 20; 47.—Hospital day: 1939. Hosp. Topics, 1939, 17: No. 4, 14-7.—Hospital day activities break record in 1936. Hosp. Management, 1936, 41: No. 6, 19; 33.— Hospital (The) exhibit at the New York World's Fair. Hos- pitals, 1938, 12: No. 3, 83.—How hospitals can build good- will with regular radio programs. In Hosp. Admin. & Org. (Hosp. Management) Chic, 1942, 95.—Information booklets stress hospital services and facilities. Ibid., 92.—Jacobson, M. A. Exhibits feature Hospital Day at St Luke's Hospital. Hosp. Management, 1941, 52: No. 4, 16.—Josephson, E. M. Pull-'em-in and steer-'em cUnics and centers. In his Merchants in Med., N. Y., 1941, 131.—Large number of joint celebra- tions feature 20th annual hospital day. Hosp. Management, 1940, 49: No. 6, 16-9. Also in Hosp. Admin. & Org. (Hosp. Management) Chic, 1942, 110-5.—Lejano, P. National hos- pital day. Month. Bull. Bur. Health, Manila, 1939, 19: loin iq. 707 o rdfa del¥ h£8pi£L BoL 0f- san- Panamer., 1940, 19: 797-9.—Leone, J. P. Getting proper publicity for your hospital. Hospitals, 1937, 11: 45-8.—Lutrario, A. ^exposition nationale des hopitaux k Rome. Bull Off internat hyg pub., Par., 1936, 28: 521-7.— McNamara, J. A. Hospital publicity; suggestions for publicizing hospital ac- 1™« m the community. West. Hosp. Rev., 1932 19: 14 —Morrow, J. R. Report of the national hospital dav com- mittee, 1930. Tr. Am. Hosp. Ass., 1931, 32: 51------■ National hospital day, 1938, at the Bergen County Hospital. Hospitals, 1938, 12: No. 10, 106-8.—National hospital day in Indiana. Ibid., 1940, 14: No. 4, 27-9.—New York Fair ex- hibits depict hospital and medical progress. Hosp. Manage- ment, 1939, 47: No. 5, 12.—Radio stations eager to cooperate in hospital day celebrations. Ibid., No. 4, 9. Also in Hosp. Admin. & Org. (Hosp. Management) Chic, 1942, 108.— Report of the committee on pubhc relations; code of ethics for hospital publicity. Tr. Am. Hosp. Ass., 1933, 35: 225-42.— Rhode Island Hospital annual report, sells institution to com- munity. In Hosp. Admin. & Org. (Hosp. Management) Chic, 1942, 102.—Roberts, N. B., & Simmons, W. G. Well planned publicity and program won 1939 award for Hinsdale. Hosp. Management, 1940, 49: No. 4, 18-20. Also in Hosp. Admin. & Org. (Hosp. Management) Chic, 1942, 80-2.— Sloan, R. P. Hospital days at Huntington. Mod. Hosp., 1936, 47: No. 2, 60-4.—When hospitals advertise. Brit. M. J., 1934, 1: 723.—Wickenden, H. The hospitals, the press and the public. Nosokomeion, Stuttg., 1937, 8: 112-6. ---- Public relations. Mills, A. B. Hospital public relations. 361p. 221/2cm. Chic, 1939. Allen, W. M. What a community thinks of its hospitals. Hospitals, 1942, 16: No. 4, 37.—Atkinson, E. M. The plight of the hospitals. In his Behind the Mask of Med., N. Y., 1941, 256-84.—Baehr, G. A national hospital day message. Mod. Hosp., 1942, 58: No. 5, 47.—Bernays, E. L. Public relations for American hospitals. Hospitals, 1940, 14: No. 12, 11-7.— Bingham, J. J. With reference to public relations. Hosp. Progr., 1940, 21: 358-60.—Black, B. W. Improvement in hospitals has increased public confidence. Hosp. Manage- ment, 1941, 51: No. 2, 16.—Bremness, D. National Hospital Day prize-winner finds public relations pays; if you don't have program, May 12 is good time to start one, declares superintendent. Ibid., 1942, 53: No. 4, 15-7.—Buck, J. V. Public relations during an emergency. Hospitals, 1941, 15: No. 5, 39-43.—Community confidence restored through public relations plan. Hosp. Management, 1941, 51: No. 3, 40.— Corwin, E. H. L. Pubhc relations of the hospital. Hospitals, 1940, 14: No. 5, 13-8.—Craig, A. Educating the.public about our hospitals; report of the committee on public education. Ibid., 1936, 10: No. 3, 101-8. ------ Hospital publicity and pubhc relations. Tr. Am. Hosp. Ass., 1937. 39: 488-90 — Davis, G. L. Relationship of pubhc hospitals to local health agencies. Ibid., 1938, 40: 792-8.—Davis, M. M., Bishop, R. H. jr. [et al.] Council on Public Education; annual report 1939. Ibid., 1939, 41: 116-21.—Davis, M. M., O'Hanlon, G. ret al.] Council on Public Education, annual report 1938. Ibid., 1938, 40: 66-9.—Davis, R. B. Don't let the public deceive you. South. M. & S., 1941, 103: 679.—Deutsch, A. S. Hospital public relations. Hospitals, 1941, 15: No. 12, 30-2.— Eichenlaub, M. H. Public relations of the hospital. Ibid., 1938, 12: No. 9, 19-23.------ Six years in public relations. Mod. Hosp., 1938, 51: No. 2, 43.—Emch, A. F. Basic principles of public relations. Hospitals, 1940, 14: No. 10, 103; No. 11, 99.—Evansville plan of public relations. Tr. Am. Hosp. Ass., 1933, 35: 247-60.—Fishbein, M. The hospital and the public Ibid., 1927, 29: 156-73.—Frothingham, C. What are small hospitals doing to improve their community relations? Bull. Am. Hosp. Ass., 1935, 9: 23-7.—Fuller, I. H. Hospital re- ceptionist important in obtaining community good will. Hosp. Management, 1942, 53: No. 2, 64.—Goodloe, H. L. Importance of improved service as basis of public relations. Hospitals, 1942, 16: No. 2. 59.—Griffin. M. F. The challenge to hospitals in the changing attitude toward them. Proc. Congr. M. Educ, 1941, 7-13.—Grossman, M. R. Underlying principles of the public relations problem. Bull. Am. Coll. Surgeons, 1942, 27: 66.—Hatfield, J. N. The theoretical and practical aspects of an association public relations program. Hospitals, 1937, 11: No. 6, 104-6.—Healy, L. R. Progressive hospitals recognize need for public good-will. Hosp. Management, 1942, 53: No. 2, 70.—Hiscock, I. V. Mutual interests of hospitals and public health organizations. Hospitals, 1936, 10: No. 1, 9-13.—Howe, F. S. A practical basis for a public relations program. Tr. Am. Hosp. Ass., 1933, 35: 242-7.— Huntington, R. S. A job for every trustee. Mod. Hosp., 1941 57: No. 5, 73.—Kleinschmidt, H. E. The hospital breaks out of its walls. Hospitals, 1938, 12: No. 11, 59-61.— Kohlaas, W. S. Good will through pubhc opinion. Ibid., 1940 14: No. 7, 87-9.—MacEachern, M. T. Essential factors in a'new deal for the hospital field; hospital-minded com- munity placed first by Dr MacEachern in comprehensive study of conditions that will make for prosperity. Hosp. Management, 1933, 36: 17-20. —---- Hospital ethics, publicity, and public relations. Bull. Am. Hosp. Ass., 1934, 8: 28-35. ------ Acquainting the public with its hospitals. HOSPITAL ADMINISTRATION 820 HOSPITAL ADMINISTRATION Ibid., No. 9, 04 70.- McCaw, F. G. Good business telations. Hospitals, 1940, 14: No. 12, 46-8.—MacLean, B. C. Craig, A. let al.] Report of the Committee on Public Health Rela- tions, 1937. Tr. Am. Hosp. Ass., 1937, 39: ISO 9.--Mannix, J. R. Round table on public relations. Ibid., 1938, 40: 762 74.—Meek. F. Getting along with people. Hospitals, 1939, 13: No. S. 1S-21.— Miller. V.. Adelman, P. |et al.] Re- port of the Committee on Public Education, 1936. Tr. Am. Hosp. Ass., 1936, 38: 110-22.—Morgenstern, W. V. Basic piinciples of public relations. Hospitals, 1939, 13: No. 6, 13-6.- Mulrov, J. R. Hospital publicity and community relations. Hosp. Progr., 1934, 15: 443 -5.—O'Toole, J. J. ( dntiilintion of the community to the hospital; an attorney's view. Ibid., 1938, 19: 159.—Public relations policies; a cross- section of opinion. Mod. Hosp., 1940, 55: 57-9.—Reilly. G. J. Contribution of the community to the hospital; view of a supervisor. Hosp. Progr., 1938, 19: 164.—Report of the Com- mittee on Public Relations. Tr. Am. Hosp. Ass., 1932, 34: 450-95.— Rice. W. O. Speaking for the hospital. Mod. Hosp., 1939, 53: No. 2, 68.—.Sister >ita. The hospital administrator and pubhc relations. Hospitals, 1941, 15: No. 9, 23-6.— Smith, H. A. Public relations program for a hospital. Ibid., 1942, 16: tto. 2, 101—4.—Sutley, M. L. Hospital publicity and public relations,, a du-< ussion. Tr. Am. Hosp. Ass., 1937, 39: 491 -3.—lipham, J. H. J. The modern hospital and its relation to the city. Uiplomate, 1933, 5: 61-4.—Walter, F. J. To create understanding—pubhc relations. Bull. Am. Coll. Surgeons, 1936, 21 : 29. ---- Purchasing. American hospital association. Manual of specifications for the purchase of hospital supplies and equipment. 734p. 22^cm. Chic. [1940?] Arrowsuith, L. M. Purchasing routine. Hospitals, 1941, 15: No. 2, 40-2. ------Gould, C. F. [et al.] The Commi'tee on Simplification and Standardization of Hospital Furnishings, Supplies, and Equipment. Tr. Am. Hosp. Ass., 1938, 40: 128-37.—Audain, G. Les profiteurs des hopitaux. Ann. mid. Haiti, 1933. 10: 180-7.—Ahslander, C. O. Relationship between purchasing agents and sales managers. Hospitals, 1941, 15: No. 8, 88-91 .—Benson, J. G. Relationship of the purchasing agent to the superintendent and department heads. Tr. Am. Hoap. Ass., 1938, 40: 418-23.—Bert, J. F. How the buyer can save money through research and salvage. Ibid., 1937, 39: 806-16. ------ Standardization important factor in purchase of surgical supplies. In Hosp. Admin. & Org. (Hosp. Management') Chic, 1942, 52. ------ Purchase furniture and equipment for service, price and durability. Ibid., 6_'. — Buerki. R. C. Expanding demands of medicine. In Hosp. Yeail... 1911, 19: 974-6.—Burroughs, P. L. Pur- cha-ing procedure. Hospitals, 1941, 15: No. 11, 73; passim.— Code i The) and contract board and the hospitals. Week. Bull. S. Louis M. Soc, 1934, 28: 322.—Crain, G. D., jr. How to get more for the hospital dollar. In Hosp. Admin. & Org. (Hosp. Management) Chic, 1942, 51.—Dressier. Einkaufs- zentralen und Einkaufsgemeinschaften fiir Krankenanstalten. Zschr. ges. Krankenhauswes., 1927, 23: 681-5.—Fuqua, R. S. Economics of purchasing drugs, solutions, and gases. Hos- pitals, 1941, 15: No. 11, 56-9.—Gately, W. A. The advantages to hospitals of cooperative buying. Tr. Am. Hosp. Ass., 1937, 39: 817-22.—Gliemo, J. C. A centralized system for hospital purchasing. Hosp. Management, 1938, 46: No. 5, 15.— Gould, C. Small orders mean high costs. Mod. Hosp., 1941, 57: No. 5, 63.—Hooper, H. N. Specifications and government purchasing. Hospitals, 1940, 14: No. 12, 69-73.—Hornal, J. Purchasing procedure. Tr. Am. Hosp. Ass., 1939, 41: 362-70. Also Hospitals, 1939, 13: No. 12, 60-4.—Hueston, R. M. Buying for the small hospital; how can it be systematized? Mod. Hosp., 1929, 32: No. 6, 53-8.—Hunt,S.K. Adaptability of routine hospital purchasing procedure to the small hospital. Tr. Am. Hosp. Ass., 1939, 41: 371-6. Also Hospitals, 1939, 13: No. 11, 55-7.—Lutes, J. D. Who should do the hospital buying? Hosp. Topics, 1937, 15: No. 2, 123.—MacEachern, M. T., Dann. B. D. [et al.] Report of the Committee on Simpli- fication and Standardization of Hospital Furnishings, Supplies and Equipment, 1936. Tr. Am. Hosp. Ass., 1936, 38: 139-63 — Manz, P. Der Einkauf in den offentlichen und subventio- nierten Krankenanstalten; Submission, Preisberatungsstelle oder freier Einkauf. Nosokomeion, Stuttg., 1937, 8: 236-43.— Martin, J. B. H. The sealed bid system. Tr. Am. Hosp. Ass., 1938, 40: 433-6.—Mason, B. H. Brevities on the psychology and mechanics of institutional purchasing. Ibid., 1933, 35: 362-71.—Munson, H. A. Blanket buying. Hospitals, 1941, 15: 31-3.—Nichols, L. H. Purchase and issue should be systematized in every hospital. Hosp. Management, 1939, 48: No. 4, 35-7. Also in Hosp. Admin. & Org. (Hosp. Manage- ment) Chic, 1912, 71-3.—Palmer, D. H. [Hospital] Scientific equipment and instruments [in war-time] Bull. Am. Coll. Surgeons, 1942, 27: 43.—Slack, E. L. Purchasing for future needs in an emergen' y program. Hospitals, 1941, 15: No. 5, 44—6.—Stephens, G. F. How I would conduct my institutional purchasing if I had .i free hand. Tr. Am. Hosp. Ass., 1936, 38: 616-9.—Stcut. M. L. Purchasing for a small hospital Hospitals, 1939, 13: No. 6, 87.—Walir.sley, E. H. Buying for the gift shop. Mod. Hosp., 1940, 55: 52.—Wolf, E. C. Pro- cedure for purchasing on bid basis. Hospitals, 1941, 15: No. 8, 38-40.—Wood, G. U. Hospital purchasing agents and salesmen. Tr. Am. Hosp. Ass., 1938, 40: 421-8.—Zaagmnn, H. Consider quality, quantity, time and price when purchasing printed forms. Hosp. Management, 1940, 50: No. 1, 29. Also in Hosp. Admin. & Org. (Hosp. Management) Chic 1942, 69. ---- rural, and small. Barthelmfs, A. L'administration du petit hopital. Nosoko- meion, Stuttg., 1934, 5: 57-60.—Berezhny, S. I. [\Vork plan of the hospitals of the rural medical district of Ostapievo in the Poltava region for 1941] Radianska med., 1941, 6: Xo. 3 51-61.—Branton, A. F. Problems of hospitals in small towns' and rural areas. J. Lancet, 1935, 55: 239-44. Itucrki, R. C. Round table on small hospital problems, September 15 11)37' Tr. Am. Hosp. Ass., 1937, 39: 616-31.—Davis. G. L. Pn'.bl'ems of the small hospital in the South. Ibid., 1938, 40: 577-82. ------ The small hospital problem. Hospitals, 1940 14: No. 11, 32-7. Also repr.—Foust, A. C. How small hospitals may be made self-supporting. Trained Nurse, 1937, 99: 641—4.—Griffiths, A. The contributory scheme of an English county hospital. Bull. Am. Hosp. Ass., 1933, 7: 40-5.__ Hardgrove, A. E. Round table on small hospital problems September 29, 1938. Tr. Am. Hosp. Ass., 1938, 40: 730-61.— How 17 [small] hospitals conserve equipment and supplies Mod. Hosp., 1941, 57: No. 4, 87. - Hughes, A. M. House management in a small hospital. Hospitals, 1939, 13: No. 6 103.—Jackson, R. The possibilities for administration, man- agement and accounting of the smaller and rural hospitals Nosokomeion, Stuttg., 1934, 5: 18-21.— I.indquist, C. A., Walker, M. F. [et al.] The organization and management of the small hospital. Bull. Am. Coll. Surgeons, 1940, 25: 82- 92.—McDonald, M. Organization and management of a 5(1 bed community hospital. Hosp. Management 1927 23- No. 4, 46.—M^tEathern, M. T. The small hospital; organiza- tion and management. J. Am. M. Ass., 1939, 112: 1185-7.__ Mackenzie, G. M. Collectivism in a rural hospital. Med Care, 1942, 2: 127-33.—Mother M. Immaculata, & Conway! M. A. A symposium on the small hospital. Hosp Progr' 1939, 20: 74-81.—Problem (The) of the small hospital. Nurs' Times, Lond., 1936, 32: 469-71.—Rsbinovich, P. L. [Organiza- tion of work in rural hospitals] Sovet. vrach. J., 1937, 2: 45-55.—Rankin, W. S. The rural hospital; its purposes and management. Mod. Hosp., 1935, 44: 41-5.—Robbins, W. E. Administering the small hospital. I Li 1., 1942, 58: 68.— Salomon, H. Rationelle Organisation lines mittleren Kran- kenhauses. Zschr. ges. Krankenhauswes., 1928,24: 329-31.__ Small hospital problems emphasized at annual tri-state as- sembly. Hosp. Management, 1940, 49: No. 5, 16-8.—Thrasher, J. W. The small hospital and its principal problems. Hos- pitals, 1940, 14: No. 5, 45-8.—Uppendahl, F. Striving for perfection 111 a small hospital. Ibid., 1937, 11: No. 4, 87.— Wolff, E. E. The need for and the management of a small hospital. Bull. Am. Hosp. Ass., 1932, 6: 82-92.—Wright, A. Administration in small hospitals. Canad. Nurse, 1941, 37: ---- Safety. Buck, G. H. Safety in hospitals. Hospitals, 1941, 15: No. 7, 86-9.------ Importance of general equipment and personnel in a hospital safety program. Ibid., No. II, 45-8.__ Busch, M. L Obstetrical and nursery equipment as it applies to safety in hospitals. Ibid., No. 12, 103-8.—Gorrell, J. E. Physical therapy equipment as it applies to safety in hospitals. Ibid., 1942, 16: 26-8.—Hoffmann, W., & Unger, R. Unfall- verhutungsvorschriften fur die Betriebe des Gesundheits- wesens. /schr. ges. Krankenhauswes., 1930, 365.—Schulz, J. Unfallverhutung im Krankenhaus. Chirurg, 1939 11 • 617- 24.—Seltzer, W. B. Means of eliminating falls in hospitals. Hospitals, 1940, 14: No. 7, 51-4.—Slack, E. L. Safety-minded- ness in the hospital. Ibid., No. 6, 56-9— Sterling L. B. Accident prevention in the hospital. Ibid., 71-5. ---- Sanitation. ,„o^n^rs?Tn' 5*V,B- Windows clear and clean. Mod. Hosp., W 1& No-3, 88-90.—Bailie, M. A. War declared on pests. Ibid., 1941, 56: No. 2, 102.—Boyd, J. E. M. Bats in the belfry. J. R. Army M Corps, 1938, 71: 346-9.—Chuan, S. H. Hospi- tals and health. China M. J., 1927, 41: 229-34.—Com by, J., & Rousseau [et al.] Quand pourrons-nous vivre sans bruit et manger nos aliments non souillcs? Hopital, Par., 1933, 21: 438-48.—Destruction de inmundicias en los hospitales. Bol. Of. san. panamer., 1942, 21: 78— Drigalski, von. Hygiene im neuen Krankenhaus. Gesundh. Ingenieur, 1929, 52- 461-3 — Farenholi, A. Disposal of hospital garbage and trash. U. S. Nay. M Bull. 1929, 27: 310, 2 pl., ch.-Gehrenbeck, K. Desinfektion und Sterilisation im Krankenhaus. Gesundh. Ingenieur, 1939, 62: 463-8.—Grushko, V. M. [Disposal of refuse of the district hospitals] Sovet. med., 1940, 4: No 19, 42— Guthjahr. Pflegliche Behandlung der mit Linoleum eiegtcn 1 ussboden und der Steinholzfussboden. Zschr. ges. ,J?Pkfenliauswes., 1931, 435.—Hopitaux. J. chim. med.. Par., 1865, 5. sir., 1: 90-4 —Kopp, R. Wolldecken- und Federbett- Entseuchung (und -Entwesung) mit dem Rubner-Apparat im Krankeiihausbetrieb. Zschr. ges. Krankenhauswes., 1927, 23: 1 , .. ,Len*.erklren» H- von- Ueber Schadlinge und deren Bekampfung un Krankenhaus. Ibid., 1935, 278-81.—Liese. W. HOSPITAL ADMINISTRATION 821 HOSPITAL ADMINISTRATION Einige hygienische Gesichtspunkte bei Licht- und Beleuchtungs- fragen im Krankenhaus. Gesundh. Ingenieur, 1939, 62: 468- 70.—Lommel, A. Die gesundheitstechnischen Einrichtungen der neuen Universitats-Frauenklinik in Wurzburg. Ibid., 1936, 59: 637-40.—McIver, P. La enfermeria sanitaria. Bol. Of. sari, panamer., 1939, 18: 744-53.—Mamer, L. J. Air condition- ing and bacteria control of operating room present many prob- lems. Hosp. Management, 1941, 52: 57-60.—Mayr, J. K. Zur Desodorierung von Krankensalen. Zschr. ges. Kranken- hauswes., 1927, 23: 479.—Minch, A. A. [Ionization of the air in hospitals] Sovet. vrach. J., 1937, 41: 922-31.—Neumark, E. Die Bekampfung der Fliegenplage in Krankenanstalten. Zschr ges. Krankenhauswes., 1927, 23: 429.—Rockwood, H. L. Public health within the hospital. Ohio M. J., 1934, 30: 306- 9 —S tally brass, C. O. Hospital administration and its relation- ship to the health department. J. R. San. Inst., 1933, 54: 301- 9,—Telmann. Hygienische Staub- und Schmutzbeseitigung im Krankenzimmer. Gesundh. Ingenieur, 1928, 51: 675-7.— Van den Ende, M., Edward, D. G. ff., & Lush, D. Reduction of dust-borne infection by treatment of bedclothes. Lancet, Lond., 1941, 1: 716-8.—Van den Ende, M., & Spooner, E. T. C. Reduction of dust-borne bacteria in a ward by treating floor and bedclothes. Ibid., 751.—Wekwerth, U. Sonne, Licht und Luft im Krankenraum; eine Betrachtung iiber den Neubau einer Klinik im Allgemeinen Krankenhaitse Hamburg-Harburg. Zschr. ges. Krankenhauswes., 1941, 37: 161-4.—Wolfson, Z. G. [Organization of sanitary-chemical protection in district hospi- tals] Sovet. med., 1940, No. 16, 36-40. --- Supply. See also Hospital industry. Gorgas, N. The storage and issuance of hospital supplies. 78p. 21cm. Chic. [1940] Modern (The) hospital year book; the hospital reference book. 12. ed., 1932. 707p. 4? Chic, 1932. Amberg, R. Wax and soap. Tr. Am. Hosp. Ass., 1938, 40: 437-43.—Arrowsmith, L. M. Surgical dressings, rubber goods, and supplies of a similar nature. Bull. Am. Coll. Surgeons, 1942, 27:44.—Baum, C. H. The purchase of supplies. Tr. Am. Hosp. Ass , 1929, 31: 121-7.—Boyd, R. G. Control of supplies in a small hospital. Hospitals, 1939, 13: 46-50.—Brisbane, R. D. Hospital thieves we have known. Mod. Hosp., 1940, 55: 43.— Crain, K. C. Essential hospital supplies face increasing war restrictions; WPB, representatives of industry search for ways to solve shortages. Hosp. Management, 1942, 53: No. 5, 13. ----- Technical council set up to aid hospital supply pro- gram. Ibid., 13.—Cutler, C. W., jr. Organizing a central sup- ply room for hospital service. N. York State J. M., 1935, 35: 485-90.—Davis, L. The contribution of branded merchan- dise to the patient's recovery. Hospitals, 1941, 15: No. 5, :i4-8.—Doane, J. C. Central supplv service. Mod. Hosp., 1939, 53: No. 5, 73.—Ernestine, M., & Borgia, M. The advantage of central treatment-tray service in the hospital. Hospitals, 1936, 10: No. 2, 28.—Escudero, P. La provision de pan a los Hospitales Municipales de Bs. As., estudio t^cnico y administrativo. Sem. mdd., B. Air., 1933, 40: pt 1, 805-11 — Hamilton, S. Central supply room versus sectional supply service. Bull. Am. Hosp. Ass., 1935, 9: 105-11.—Hospital alcohols. Hospitals, 1941, 15: No. 12, 95.—King, F. Handling of supplies; purchasing, storing, receiving, distribution, exchange, economies, costs. Bull. Am. Coll. Surgeons, 1933, 17: 47-9.— Koyen, H. The specification and purchase of institutional linen. Hosp. Management, 1939, 48: No. 6, 27.—Mills, A. B. & Zimmerman, R. H. Hospitals and priorities, a summary to date. Mod. Hosp., 1941, 57: No. 5, 43-5.—Morgan. H. Discovering paper. R. N., Rutherford, 1940-41, 4: No. 4, 24.—Morrill, W. P. Setting up a supply system. Hospitals, 1940, 14: No. 8, 87-90.—Penn, R., & Ward, A. A. The control of hospital supplies. Hosp. Management, 1935, 39: 27-31 — Rowley. E. G. Supplies system for small hospital. Mod. Hosp., 1938, 50: No. 4, 63.—Save salvage, simplify, U. S. official tells hospital administrators; Tri-State Program, permeated by war considerations, peers ahead. Hosp. Management, 1942, 53: No. 5, 21-3.—Shortage of materials may require hospitals to use sub- stitutes. Ibid., 1941, 51: No. 6, 26; 72.—Sister Lydia. Manage- ment of hospital supplies. Hospitals, 1938, 12: No. 5, 46-8. Also Hosp. Topics, 1938, 16: No. 5, 14.—Wilinsky, C. F. Supply service and efficiency control. Hospitals, 1940, 14: No. 11, 38-41.—Xavier. M. F. Central supply service. Hosp. Progr., 1932, 13: 395-9.—Zimmerman, R. H. Reorganization under W. P. B. effects slight changes in hospital agencies. Mod. Hosp., 1942, 58: No. 3, 114. --- Supply: Storage. Auslander, C. O. File; don't pile. Hosp. Management, 1940, 50: No. 5, 37.—Hildreth, T. L. Stores. Hosp. News, Wash., 1938, 5: No. 19, 42-7.—Reese. L. L. Central supply room and cost of installation. Hospitals, 1942, J6: No. 3, 48- 53.—Sandaas, O. J. Watch those storeroom shelves. Mod. Hosp., 1937, 48: No. 4, 69. ■--- Taxes. Berk, W. Steuergutscheine und Krankenanstalten. Zschr. ges, Krankenhauswes., 1939, 360-3.—Blocker. Neues Lohn- steuerrecht ab 1. April 1941. Ibid., 1941, 37: 176.—Charitable hospitals; exemption from taxation. J. Am. M. Ass., 1937, 109: lbo5.—Crain, K. C. Tax exemption rights of hospitals periled by new legislation; muddle over Federal rubber excise tax re- veals possible dangers inherent in current situation. Hosp Management, 1942, 53: No. 2, 11.------Congressional Committee hears hospitals' tax exemption case. Ibid., No. 4, 11.—Daniel, H. [Taxation of hospitals] Ugeskr. laeger, 1939, 101: 126-33—Hayt, E. Tax exemption of charitable hospitals. Hospitals, 1940, 14: No. 1, 22-6.—Hoehler. F. K. Tax funds and the voluntary hospital. Tr. Am. Hosp. Ass., 1937, 39: 839-45.—Hospital victims of old tax law promised legislative relief. Hosp. Management, 1942, 53: No. 3, 20.—Hospitals; criteria of charitable character for tax purposes. J. Am. M. Ass., 1940, 115: 1748.—Hospitals and Federal tax regulations. Hospitals, 1942, 16: No. 5, 65.—Hospitals; sanatorium not exempt from taxation. J. Am. M. Ass., 1939, 112: 470 [Wis- consin]—Hospitals subject to tax. Ibid., 1942, 118: 469.— Lashins, I. R. Federal tax regulations relating to corporations engaged in charitable services. Hospitals, 1942, 16: No. 5, 21-4.—Mikocki, A. Die Umsatzsteuer und die offentlichen Krankenhauser Oesterreichs. Zschr. ges. Krankenhauswes., 1939, 102-4,—Rapp, A. Wann ist von Krankenanstalten bei Anstaltsumsatzen fiir die Umsatzsteuer der erhohte Steuersatz von 2ViJ0 anzuwenden? Ibid., 1938, 535-8. ------ Ueber- sicht uber die Steuervergiinstigungen fiir den Neuhausbesitz nach dem Grundsteuergesetz vom 1. April 1938, die auch fiir Krankenanstalten Bedeutung haben. Ibid., 549-51.—Rohde, H. Steuerhche Behandlung der Krankenanstalten. Ibid., 1939, 357-60. ------ Gewerbesteuerpflicht der Krankenanstalten. Ibid., 417. ------ Die Steuerpflicht der gemeinnlitzigen und mildtatigen Krankenanstalten. Ibid., 498.—Schier, J. Wie lassen sich in Kranken-, Heil- und Pflegeanstalten Ersparnisse an sozialen Beitragen und an Einkommensteuern erzielen? Ibid., 1929, 25: 39-42.—Schorn. Zur Frage der Umsatzsteuer- pflicht privater gemeinnutziger Krankenanstalten unter be- sonderer Berucksichtigung der Rechtsprechung des Reichs- finanzhofs. Ibid., 1933, 335-40.—St. Haussteuer- und Wohl- fahrtsabgabefreiheit ofTentlicher Krankenanstalten. Ibid., 1939, 18.—Tax exemption for hospitals. Mod. Hosp., 1941, 57: No. 4, 49.—Taxation of charitable institutions. Hosp. Progr., 1942, 23: 128-30.—Water rates charged hospitals in different cities. Hospitals, 1936, 10: No. 1, 31.—Wuth, K. Die selb- standige Steuerveranlagung von Krankenanstalten. Deut. med. Wschr., 1936, 62:2015. ------ Reichsgewerbesteuer und Krankenanstalten. Ibid., 1938, 64: 199. ■------ Die Steuer- befreiung privater Krankenanstalten. Ibid., 1939, 65: 1500. Die Steuervergiinstigungen bei der Hauszinssteuer fiir Privatkrankenanstalten. Ibid., 1940, 66: 690. ---- Voluntary hospitals. Balance (The) sheet of the voluntary hospitals. Brit. M. J., 1934, 2: 527.—Bourne, G. Administration of voluntary hospi- tals. Ibid., 1941, 2: 891; 1942, 1: 165.—Boyd, D. Voluntary institutions' •administration to-day. Ulster M. J., 1938, 7: 105-14.—Brojwn, N. G. Can the voluntary hospital maintain its independence? Tr. Am. Hosp. Ass., 1937, 39: 845-9. Also Hospitals, 1937, 11: No. 11, 29-31.—Budget (The) of London voluntary hospitals. Lancet, Lond., 1937, 2: 273.—Calvin, A. M. Reconstruction problems. Hospitals, 1937, 11: No. 9, 33-9.—Eason, H. L. The future relation of municipalities to voluntary hospitals; the question of co-operation between voluntary and municipal hospitals. Brit. M. J., 1927, 2: 575- 82.—Emch, A. F. Tax exemption for voluntary hospitals. Hospitals, 1940, 14: No. 4, 71-5.—Goldwater, S. S. Voluntary hospitals, for profit only. Ibid., 1941, 15: No. 7, 27.—Hoehler, F. K. Tax funds and the voluntary hospital. Ibid., 1937, 11: No. 10, 72-5.—Kingsley, S. C. How should voluntary hospi- tals be financed? Bull. Am. Hosp. Ass., 1935, 9: 28-33.— Lapenta, V. A. Problems of the voluntary hospital in our changing times. Hosp. Progr., 1940, 21: 93.—Macdonald, P. Voluntary hospitals (paying patients) bill. Brit. M. J., 1935, 1: (Suppl.) 133.—Mackenzie, M. Administration of voluntary hospitals. Ibid., 1942, 1: 93.—MacLean, B. C. Voluntary hospitals and the Social Security Act. Tr. Am. Hosp. Ass., 1939, 41: 692-704.—Mix, D. S. Presenting the case of volun- tary hospitals to the people. Hospitals, 1941, 15: No. 3, 35-8.— Orchard, W. J. The need for governmental assistance to hospitals and its effect upon the voluntary hospital system. Tr. Am. Hosp. Ass., 1939, 41: 682-92.—Skillman, D. B. The part philanthropy plays in the support of voluntary hospitals. Ibid., 1937, 39: 850-9.—Smith, C. F. A policy and program for a voluntary hospital. Hosp. Management, 1937, 44: No. 2, 20; 58.—Stone, J. E. Organization and administration of American and British voluntary hospitals. Tr. Am. Hosp. Ass., 1939, 41: 664-71.—Sumner, W. A. The charitable ele- ment in the support of voluntary hospitals. Ibid., 1937, 39: 527-31.—Voluntary hospitals and a ministry of health. Brit. M. J., 1918, 2: 468.—Voluntary (The) hospital; are changes necessary? West. Hosp. Rev., 1936-37, 24: No. 4, 5; 10.— Voluntary (The) hospitals commissions. Brit. M. J., 1936, 1: 419.—Voluntary (The) hospital principle. Lancet, Lond., 1935, 1: 1336. ---- Waste and salvage. Burroughs, P. L. Salvage for victory in hospitals. Hospitals, 1942, 16: No. 3, 44.—Nelson, E. H. Employes offer suggestions for reducing waste in this hospital, Hosp. Management, 1941, HOSPITAL ADMINISTRATION 822 HOSPITAL ADMINISTRATOR 52: Xo. 5, 19.—Oehlcr. Kampf dem Verderb im Krankenhaus. Zschr. ges. Krankenhauswes., 1939, 207-16.—Rourke, A. J. J. Conservation of supplies. Hospitals, 1941, 15: No. 5, 56-8.— Wilson, L. R. The graveyard of unused equipment. Hosp. Management, 1938, 45: No. 5, 23.—Zaagman, H. The value and control of setup, surplus and obsolete materials. Ibid., 1940, 49: 28. Also Hosp. Admin. & Org. (Hosp. Management) Chic, 1912, 77. ---- in wartime. Agne, E. Kriegswirtschaftsrecht und Krankenhauser. Zschr. ges. Krankenhauswes., 1939, 521-3.— Aita. A. A. Econ- omv helps pi event scarcity. Hospitals, 1942, 16: No. 5, 33.— Burroughs. P. I,. Priorities and the hospital. Ibid., 1941, 15: No. 6, 55.- Civil war in Spain. J. Am. M. Ass., 1939, 113: 159.—College (The) hospitals, and the program of civilian defense. Bull. Am. Coll. Surgeons, 19-12. 27: 11-4— Crain, K. C. Priorities for hospital needs given increasing recognition. Hosp. Management, 1941, 52: No. 3, 19. —---- New list, of supplies and repair and inventory order issued by OPM. Ibid., No. 4, 13.—Creakbaum, W. M. War and reconstruction to change management methods. Ibid., 1942, 53: No. 4,32 — Cross, K. A. Improved position for health supplies anticipated under operation of PRP. Mod. Hosp., 1942, 58: No. 5, 110.—Defense and inter-American relations outstanding con- vention topics. Hosp. Management, 1941, 52: No. 4, 17; 49.— Federal regulation alTecting priorities, rationing and price fixing. HospraK 1942, 16: No. 4, 39-44; No. 5, 75.—Hahn, M. Hospitals first New York says: yes! Mod. Hosp., 1936, 46: No. 2. 54-9.—Hill, F. S. Administrative work in a general hospital in war-time. J. R. Army M. Corps, 1930, 54: 274-9.— . Hospitals find allocations program becoming increasingly serious. Hosp. Management, 1941, 52: No. 6, 16.—Houser, G. F. Hospital ail ministration under wartime conditions. Hospi- tals, 1941, 15: No. 12, 33-8.—Jones, E. W. Hospitals must reduce use of all commodities by 10 per cent. Hosp. Manage- ment, I'll I. 52: No. 6, 63-6.—Luce, M. H. Priority problems of the ho-pital. Hospitals, 1941, 15: No. 10, 27-9— Mac- Eachern, M. T. Our hospitals are on the alert. Ibid., 1942, 16: No. 2, 71.—Masoner, K. W. Mobilization for defense production affects supply of hospital equipment. Hosp. Management, 1941. 51: No. 6, 15.—Metzger, W. M. Practical problems of hospitals in wanime. Hospitals, 1942, 16: No. 5, 95.—Morrill, W. P. lacing war demands. Ibid., No. 3, 33- 7.— New York's adopted hospital, the London Chest Hospital finds a friend in need. Nuis. Times, Lond., 1941, 37: 130.— Oflicc (Tlie) of Production Management and hospitals. Hospi- tals, 19-11, 15: No. 9, 08. Official plan for priority rating for health supplies including hospitals, clinics, and sanitaria. Ibid., 40-2.—Oseroff, A. Available commodities for health services will be allocated to hospitals. Ibid., 1942, 16: No. 5, 48-51. - S., A. M. Preference ratings of special interest to the ha-piials, priorities. Hosp.- Progr., 1941, 22: 314-6.—Shands, A. R., jr. Needs of hospitals supplied through priorities. Hospitals, 1942, 16: No. 5, 44-7. - Sister M. Michael la. Conservation duiing wartime. Ibid., 56.- Smith, N. The hospital and national defense. Ibid., No. 3, 54- s.—U. S. hospitals already geared for emergencies of war: administrators of small institutions must be able to handle varied tasks. Hosp. Management, 1942, 53: No. 4, 20.—War-time emergencies discussed at Ontario Hospi- tal Association convention. Canad. M. Ass. J., 1941, 45: 559. HOSPITAL administrator. American College of Hospital Adminis- trators. Directory, 1941. 237p. 2.r)Kcm. Chic. [1941] Ackerman, S. 11. A hospital adminisi lator's work day Hospitals, 1939, 13: No. 6, 21-3.—Adair, F. L. Administrative and clinical efficiency and control. Bull. Am. Coll. Surgeons, 1939, 24: 194-6.—American college of hospital administrators; program, Boston, September, 1940. Hospitals, 1940, 14: No. 9, 63.—Bachmeyer, A. C. Hospital executives need a group consciousness. Mod. Hosp., 1926, 27: 45-8.—Bishop. H. E. The address of the president, American College of Hospital Administrators. Hospitals, 1937, 11: No. 11, 18-21.—Blue- stone, E.M. Selections from the notebook of a hospital adminis- trator. J. Mount Sinai Hosp. N. York, 1941-42, 8: 409-17.— Bradley. F. R. The administrator and hi> hospital. Hospitals 1939, 13: No. 12, 28-31.—Brisbane. R. I). The administrator's wife. Mod. Hosp., 1941, 57: No. 6. 57. -Carter, F. G. Ad- ministrative leadership. Hospitals. 1936, 10: No. 6, 67-69.— Co-ordination of hospital administrators. Brit. M. J., 1941, 2: 705.— Davis, M. M., Bacon. A. S. [et al.] Report of the Com- mittee on Arrangements for the Institute for Hospital Adminis- trators, 1936. Tr. Am. Hosp. Ass., 1936, 38: 186.—Doane, J. C. The ideal hospital administrator. Hosp. Progr., 1926, 7: 316-9. ------ Tongue blades and administrator*. Mod Hosp.. 1937. 48: 79-81.—Ellis. W. J. A carreer in public hospital management. Hospitals, 1941, 15: No. 10, 80-4.— Ffcchvereinigung der Verwaltungsleitei Deutscher Kranken- Heil- und Pflegeanstalten; Niederschrift iiber die 29. ordentliche Hauptversamrolung in Frankfurt a. Main vom 30. Juni bis 3 Juli 1938. Zschi L'e~. Krankenhauswes., 1938, 337; 361; 389.— F»'ey. M. (). A\hat are superintendents paid? an analysis of the highest and lowest salaries paid to hospital administrators based on almost 350 confidential returns from all over the coun- try. Hosp. Management, 1930, 29: 29. ------ Are superin- tendents necessary or are they luxuries? while this should be a foolish question with just one answer (They're essential) actions of some boards indicate lack of appreciation of value of administrative experience. Ibid., 1933, 35: 17 9. (iuthjahr, \V. Ueber 30 Jahre Fachvereinigung der leitenden Verwalt ungs- beamten deutscher Krankenanstalten. Zschr. ges. Kranken- hauswes., 1934, 289-91. —— Zur 28. HauptverMimrnlung der Fachvereinigung der Yerwaltungsleiter deutscher kiaiiken-, Heil- und Pflegeanstalten. Ibid., 1937, 261. Hamilton. J. a! The college of hospital administrator; its significance. Hospi- tals, 1938, 12: No. 8, 43-8.—Hodden. H. Ihe American College of Hospital Administrators. Memphis M. J., 1936, n: No. 2, 16; 33.—Hospitals and-their executive officers. Med. I Australia, 1941, 1: 761. Josephson, E. M. Profits of hospital directors. In his Merchants in Med., N. Y., 1911, 127 MacEachern, M. T. The College of Hospital Administiat ion Hosp. Progr., 1926, 7: 31.1 5. Macl.ean, B. C. The first fifteen months. Mod. Hosp., 1935. 45: No. 3, 41 4. -Maudsley (The) Hospital and its superintendent. Brit. M. J., 1939, 2: 1012.—Muller, E. Der wirtschaftliche Knuikeiihausli iter Zschr. ges. Krankenhauswes., 1927, 23: 298.- National (The) Conference of Hospital Administrators. Hospitals, 1912 16: No. 3, 77—O'Connell, M. J. Hospital progress and its chief victims, hospital administrators. Ibid., 19 11, 15: No. I, 13 7.—■ Olsen, E. T. The state university hospitals of Oklahoma Hosp. Management, 1938, 46: No. 2, 6-10.—Rev. Mother Ignatius. The role of the hospital administrator. Canad. Nurse, 1941, 37: 21-3— Schwitalla, A. M. Conference on hospital administration. Hosp. Progr., 1935, 16: 57 69.-- Somonte, M. G. El hospital a t raves de un gerente. Monterrey . med., 1940, No. 56, 1357 -9- Stewart. S. What trustees expect of the administrator. Hospitals, 1941, 15: No. 3. 85.- Three R's for the hospital supt. Hosp. Topics, 1938, 16: No. 12, 1(1. Titus, S. C. Is the hospital administrator fulfilling his re- sponsibilities toward his nurses? Mod. Hosp., 1927, 28: No. 5, 49-53.—What are your opportunities for advancement? Ibid., 1941, 57: No. 5, 69.—What will the 1940 census mean to the hospital administrator? Hosp. Management, 1939, 48: No. 6, 21.—Winter, F. A. A word about superintendents. Mod. Hosp., 1926, 26: 103-6. ---- Education and training. Davis, M. M. Hospital administration, a career; the need of trained executives for a billion dollar business, and how they may be trained. 97p. 8? N. V., 1929. Bachmeyer, A. C. Educating the administrator. Hospitals, 19-12. 16: No. 2, 32.—Bacon, A. S. Interesting events in the development of institutes for hospital administrators. Ibid., 193,9, 13: No. 8, 61-3.—Bluestone, E. M. Seventy-five points to consider in training apprentices in administration. Mod. Hosp., 1942, 58: 60.—Caldwell, B. W. The training of the hospital administrator. Puerto Rico Health Bull., 1940, 4: 376-80.—Carter, F. G. Training hospital executives. Mod. Hosp., 1935, 45: No. 1, 37 -9. -Chicago (The) institute for hospital administrators. Hospitals, 1939, 13: No. 10, 59.— Chicago institute for hospital administiators, August 28 to September 11 [1940] Ibid., 1940, 14: No. 8, 44; No. 10, 116; 1941, 15: No. 9, 80.—Corso di perfezionamento in igiene e tecnica ospitaliera per aspiranti direttori sanitari di ospedalc e istituti affini, 1938-39. Osp. maggiore, Milano, 1938, 26: 546; 1939, 27: 483.—Davis, M. M. Studies in hospital administra- tion at the University of Chicago. Hospitals, 1936, 10: No. 3, 24-8. ------ Some experiences in the education of adminis- trators. Ibid., 1938, 12: 11-6.—Fitzpatrick, E. A. Considera- tions in the training of hospital executives. Mod. Hosp., 1936, 26: 23-7.—Fox, A. C. The spread of the gospel of under- standing for better education of hospital executives in America. Hosp. Progr., 1926, 7: 309-11.—Gammill, L. C. - Institutes for hospital administrators. Hospitals, 1939, 13: No. 3, 101.— Hamilton, J. A. Need for adequate education and training for hospital executives. Bull. Am. Coll. Surgeons, 1939, 24: 215 — Hardgrove, A. E. Adequate education and training for hospital administrators. Hospitals, 1939, 13: No. 3, 24-8— Hartman, G. (;raduate education in hospital administration. Bull. Am. Coll. Surgeons, 1939, 24: 217—Hazzard, A. R. Now is time to do something about training executives. Hosp. Management, 1932, 33: 45.—Hockett, A. J. Apprenticeship method of educa- tion for the hospital administrator. Hospitals, 1939. 13: No. 5, 105-7.- Institute (The) of Hospital Administration. Bull. Am. Hosp. Ass., 1935. 9: 8- 10. Also Hospitals, 1936. 10: No. 7, 85; 1938, 12: No. 6, 39. Institute for hospital administrators to be held in Chicago, September 10 22. Hull. Am. Hosp. Ass., 1931, 8: 3-7.--Institute on hospital administration, July .5-29, 1939, St Louis. 11 osp. Progr., 1939, 20: 293-6. Institutes (The) on hospital administration. Ibid.. 1940, 21: 361-71; 1941, 22: 373-91. Inter-American Institute for Hospital Administrators. Hospitals, 194(1, 14: No. 10,62. Also J. Am. M. Ass., 1940, 115: 9 15; 1735. Also Rev. Soc. med. quir. Zulia, 1940, 14: 1254.- -Kaplan, R. H. Supplementing training and experience in hospital administration. Hospitals, 1939, 13: No. 5, 108—Knowlton. W. W. What suvs the apprentice? Ibid., 1939, 13: No. 9, 10 3— Kiihne. Leber den Reichskurs fur wirtschaftliche Verwaltung in Frankfurt a. M. Zschr. ges. Krankenhauswes., 1927, 23: 412-5 — Lewinski-Corwin, E. H. The modern hospital reading course. Mod. Hosp., 1927, 28: HOSPITAL ADMINISTRATOR 823 HOSPITAL ASSOCIATION No. 1, 81; passim.—MacEachern, M. T. Intra-American relations and the first Inter-American institute for hospital administrators. Bull. Am. Coll. Surgeons, 1941, 26: 13.— Maclver, G. A. Supplementary training in hospital administra- tion. Ibid., 1939, 24: 219.—Need for individual self-develop- ment emphasized at A. C. H. A. meeting. Hosp. Management, 1940, 50: No. 4, 33.—New York Institute for Hospital Adminis- trators. Science, 1941, 94: 432.—Rourke, A. J. J. Outline for apprentice survey. Mod. Hosp., 1941, 57: No. 4, 60-2.— Sister M. Patricia. Supplementing training and experience in hospital administration. Hospitals, 1938, 12: No. 5, 94-6.— Smelzer, D. C. Apprenticeship in hospital administration. Bull. Am. Coll. Surgeons, 1939, 24: 216.—Weinstock, P. Der leitende Verwaltungsbeamte einer Krankenanstalt; seine Vor- und Fortbildung. Zschr. ges. Krankenhauswes., 1927, 23: 341- 4.—Western Institute for Hospital Administrators, Palo Alto Campus, Stanford University, August 8 to 19, 1938. Hospitals 1938, 12: No. 4, 107.—\Voiler, E. Der I. Fortbildiingslehrgang fiir Verwaltungsleitcr der Kranken-, Heil- und Pflegeanstalten. Zschr. ges. Krankenhauswes., 1939, 120-2.—Wood, N. N. The training of hospital executives in institutes for hospital administrators. Bull. Am. Coll. Surgeons, 1939, 24: 218. Selection. * Davis, M. M. The need of hospitals for com- petent directors. 8p. 8? Wash [1931] Braeuning. Worn soil die verantwortliche Leitung eines Krankenhauses ubertragen werden? Zschr. ges. Kranken- hauswes., 1926, 22: 519-23.—Cobbold, C. The aptitude and selection of candidates for hospital administrative work. Nosokomeion, Stuttg., 1933, 4: 464-8.—Davis, M. M. The need for competent hospital directors. Misc. Contr. Costs M. Care, 1931, No. 8, 1-8.—Jackson, R. Should the chief adminis- trator of a hospital be a laymen? administration tends to become a science, calling increasingly for its own special training in concrete affairs of business. Hosp. Management, 1935, 39: No. 4, 20.—Lutes, J. D. Where shall we look for trained hospi- tal administrators? Ibid., 1935, 40: 22.—Mother Mary Con- cordia. Sister personnel for the administrative functions of the hospital. Hosp. Progr., 1939, 20: 406-12.—Munger, C. W. Administrative intern. Mod. Hosp., 1939, 53: No. 3, 61-3.— She administers a small hospital. Am. J. Nurs., 1941, 41: 167- 73.—Sister Loretto Bernard. The sister superintendent; her relation with the local hospital councils and association. Hosp. Progr., 1940, 21: 372-6.—Sloan, R. P. Judging an administra- tor. Mod. Hosp., 1942, 58: 73-6.—Small (The) hospital super- visor. Am. J. Nurs., 1941, 41: 315-8.—Symington, G. Head nurse as administrator. Mod. Hosp., 1940, 55: No. 6, 75. HOSPITAL Almoners Association. The hos- pital almoner; a brief study of hospital social service in Great Britain prepared by a Committee of the Hospital Almoner's Association. 2 1. 168p. 8? Lond., G. Allen & Unwin, 1935. HOSPITAL (The) and health review. Lond., v.1-3, 1922-24. Ceased publication. HOSPITAL association. Agnew, G. H. Hospital association activities throughout the Dominion. Bull. Am. Hosp Ass., 1935, 9: 46-53. Bacon, A. S. fet al.] Report of the Committee on Membership Structure and Association Relations, 1936. Tr. Am. Hosp. Ass., 1936, 38: 188-208.—Association of Argentine hospitals. J. Am. M. Ass., 1940, 115: 1387.—Association's (The) hospital policy. Brit. M. J., 1935, 1: (Suppl.) 227.—Bachmeyer, A. C, Lattner, F. P. [et al.] Committee on Constitution and Rules, annual report 1939. Tr. Am. Hosp. Ass., 1939, 41: 106-76 — Bacon, A. S. Report of the Committee on Membership, 1937. Ibid., 1937, 39:127-32. ------Alexander, R. J. [et al.] Report of the Membership Committee, 1936. Ibid., 1936, 38: 76-9.— Bacun, A. S., Mann, J. R. [et al.] Report of the Membership Committee; annual report 1939. Ibid., 1939, 41: 132-40.— Berichte der Nationalen Krankenhaus-Gesellschaften und der nationalen Gewahrsleute. Nosokomeion, Stuttg., 1936, 7: 101-22.—Bieling. Die geschichtliche Entwicklung des Reichs- verbandes deutscher Privatkrankenanstalten und seine Ue- deutungfur die Volksgesundh it. Zschr. ges. Krankenhauswes., 1936, 375-9.—Buerki, R. C, Bates. F. O. [et al.] Report of the Joint Advisory Committee, 1936. Tr. Am. Hosp. Ass., 1936, 38: 49-53.—By-laws (The) of the American Hospital Associa- tion, adopted at the Atlantic Citv Convention, September 16, 1937. Hospitals, 1937, 11: No. 11, 68-74.—Capital (The) structure of the American Hospital Association. Bull. Am. Hosp. Ass., 1935, 9: 6.—Carter, F. G. [Greetings from] the American Hospital Association. Hosp. Progr., 1940, 21: 346.— Connecticut (The) Hospital Association. Connecticut M. J., 1942, 6: 42-5.—Costituzione (La) della sezione lombarda dell'Associazione Nazionale degli Ospedali italiani. Osp. maggiore, Milano, 1937, 25: 545-7.—Gautier, C. Rapport annuel. Bull.Soc. med. hop. Paris, 1939-40, 3. s-r., 55: 1397- 400.—Goebel, E. J. With reference to the Catholic Hospital Association. Hosp. Progr., 1940, 21: 360.—Greene, G. L. Hospital associations; are they worth what they cost physicians? I tionfo~rHf11be,w-,,d\>V- ^ report to the institute of organ z^ tion for the promotion of public health, read on May 1933 Nosokomeion, Stuttg., 1934, 5: 61-6.-Intermrtional Hospital StiXIW'VVfso^i 1= 1328' Also *°sokomSon stuttg., 1938, 9: 171-89—Langenskiold, F. Finnische Krankenhausgescllschaft. Ibid., 1934, 5: 105.-MacEacnerm l^s 19 nt Intern,?.tl0nal Hospital Association. Hospitals, £.12: N°- 4' 2l\- ------ The International Hospita S fuulToVotS,n l«S P'Lsent' and its future- N°s°komeion, Stuttg 1939, 10: 42-6.—Munger, C. W., B.tes, F. O. [et al Report of the Joint Committee of the Ameriean, Catholic and Fo^6StLnt ?.osPlta' Associations, 1937. Tr. Am. Hosp. Ass., !■«'. f9: 0079.—National, state sectional and Canadian hospital associations. In Hosp. Yearb., 1941, 19: 1011 — New (Ihe) \ork Hospital Cornell Medical College Association Med Woman J. 1933, 40: 267-71.-News from the Interna- ,£i oJiosPltal Association. Nosokomeion, Stuttg., 1935, 6: 156-286.—NoessL. How can the Colorado Hospital Associa- ™.h£l' the small outlying hospitals? Rocky Mountain M. J., 1939, 36: 326 — Official reports of the Catholic Hospital Associa- tion of the United States and Canada for the twenty-second y^. 1936-37; report of the executive board. Hosp. Progr., 1937, 18: 211-4.—Parker, J.'S. Six hundred and seventy-six general hospitals of the American Hospital Association; a statistical analysis in detail. Bull. Am. Hosp. Ass., 1929, 3: 419-27.—Reports from national hospital associations and representatives. Nosokomeion, Stuttg., 83-105.—Schwitalla, A. M. The Canadian advisory board of the Catholic Hospital Association. Hosp. Progr., 1939, 20: 334-7.—Spinelli, S. Per la istituzione dell'Associazione Nazionale degli Ospedali Italiani. Osp. maggiore, Milano, 1936, 24: 219-24.—Sutley, M. L. Developments in the hospital association of Pennsyl- vania. Hospitals, 1937, 11: No. 7, 44-7.—Weinstock, R. P. Der Vereinigung der leitenden Verwaltungsbeamten deutscher Krankenanstalten zur 25jiihrigen Griindungsfeier. Zschr ges Krankenhauswes., 1928, 24: 357-63.—Wood, W. F., Lamela, F. [et al.] Report of the Committee on Latin-American Relations. Tr. Am. Hosp. Ass., 1939, 41: 185. ---- Congresses. Schwitalla, A. M. The Silver Jubilee Con- vention of the Catholic Hospital Association of the United States and Canada; the presidential address. 67p. 12? S. Louis, 1940. [United States] Catholic Hospital Asso- ciation of the United States and Canada. Official program, June 12-16, 1939. 69p. 12? Milwaukee, Wis., 1939. ---- The Silver Jubilee Convention; the official program. 91p. 12? S. Louis, 1940. ---- _ The twenty-sixth annual convention; the official program, 1. ed. 85p. 21cm. Phila., 1941. A., R. Le congress du jubil6 d'argent de 1'Association des hopitaux catholiques americains et canadiens. Union mid. Canada, 1940, 69: 1096.—A. C. S. holds annual hospital con- ference. Hosp. Management, 1938, 46: No. 5, 21-3.—A. H. A. Convention program, Toronto, Sept. 25 to 29. Mod. Hosp., 1939, 53: No. 3, 65-71.—American Hospital Association, twenty-second annual conference, held at Montreal, Quebec October 4th to 8th, 1920. Tr. Am. Hosp. Ass., 1920, 22: 1- 409.—American Hospital Association, twenty-fourth annual conference held at Atlantic City, New Jersey September 25-28, 1922. Ibid., 1922, 24: 1-418.—American Hospital Association holds its 42d annual convention. Hospitals, 1940, 14: No. 10, 53-8.—American Protestant Hospital Association, Boston, Sept. 1940; program. Hospitals, 1940, 14: No. 9, 64.—Annual meeting of the Maritime Conference of the Catholic Hospital Association. Hosp. Progr., 1942, 23: 34-6.—Board (The) of trustees of the American Hospital Association, midyear session, June 14, 1940. Hospitals, 1940, 14: No. 7, 75.— Brennan, C. P., O'Hara, S. M. R. [et al.] Greetings to the twenty-sixth annual convention of the Catholic Hospital Association. Hosp. Progr., 1941, 22: 219-24.—Cannon, I. M. The significance to hospitals of the White House Conference. Hosp. Social Serv., 1933, 655-69.—Catholic (The) Hospital Association holds its twenty- sixth annual convention. Hospitals, 1941, 15: No. 7, 41.— Conference of voluntary hospitals. Brit. M. J., 1934, 1: 1123-6.—Convention (The) in Boston; September 16-20, 1940. Hospitals, 1940, 14: No. 6, 44-7.—Convention is roundtable on all hospital problems. Hosp. Management, 1935, 40: 15; 31.— Curtis, G. W. Western hospital convention and allied con- ference to make history. West. Hosp. Rev., 1934-35, 22: 5.— Delegation (The) of the American Hospital Association to the International Hospital Congress. Hospitals, 1937, 11: No. 7, 50.—Directory of technical exhibitors, arranged alphabetically. Hosp. Progr., 1936, 17: 201-14.—Duffy, J. A., Kelley, F. C. [et al.] Greetings to the twenty-third annual convention of the Catholic Hospital Association. Ibid., 1938, 19: 207-14.— Eleventh annual mid-year conference of the American Hospita HOSPITAL ASSOCIATION S24 HOSPITAL ASSOCIATION Association. Hospitals, 1942, 16: No. 2, 99.—Ferraro, D. ('i)imresM) internazionale degli ospedali (Roma 19-26 Maggio 1935) Ann. med. nav., Roma, 1935, 41: pt 1, 361-6- Fifth International Hospital Congress Paris, 1937. Nosokomeion, Stuttg., 1937, 8: 267-359—Flath, C. I. Toronto extends welcome to hospital convention delegates. Hosp. Management, 1939. 48: No. 3, 18-20 — Folendorf. G. Flashes from meeting of American Hospital Association. Pacific Coast J. Nurs., 1933, 29: 650-2.—Forty-first (The) annual convention of the American Hospital Association. Hospitals, 1939, 13: No. 9s 81-115; No. 10, 69-72.—Fourth International Hospital Congres, in Rome. Nosokomeion, Stuttg., 1934, 5: 286.—Fourth International Hospital Congress in Rome, 5th to 12th May, 1935. Australas. Nurs. J., 1935, 33: 61. Also ,T. Egypt. M. Ass., 1935, 18: 53.—Fricke, G. C. The first Latin American hospital convention, Santiago de Chile, Jan. 7-14, 1940. Hospitals, 1940, 14: No. 6, 13-7.—Greetings to the twenty- second annual convention of the Catholic Hospital Association. Hosp. Progr., 1937, 18: 241 3.—High points at the hospital convent! n. Trained Nurse, 1934, 93: 481-9.—Hoffmann, W. Die Verhandlungsergebnisse der IV. Internationalen Kranken- hauskongressesin Rom. Mai 1935. Zschr. ges. Krankenhauswes., 1935, 365-75.—Hospitals in the post-war world; international conference in London. Brit. M. J., 1941, 2: 819.—Hospitals of the East Bay; brief sketches of the member institutions of the East Bay Hospital Conference. West Hosp. Rev., 1936-37, 24: No. 2; 35-42.—Hospital week at Atlantic Citv, September 1.5-19, 1941. Hospitals, 1941, 15: No. 8, 60-4.—House (The) of delegates; proceedings of the Dallas session; report of the sessions of the House of delegates of the American Hospital Association. Ibid., 1938, 12: No. 11, 78-102.—Iowa hospitals enjey best convention in history. Hosp. Management, 1934, 37: 23.—Kille, E. C. Sixth annual tri-state institute. Occup. Ther. Rehubil., 1939, 18: 263-7.—McNamara, J. A. Cleveland; our convention city. Hospitals, 1936, 10: No. 9, 41-50 — Maglione, O'Connell. W. [et al.] Messages to the 25th annual conventii n of the Catholic Hospital Association. Hosp. Progr., 1940, 21: 213-27.—Minutes of the meeting of the Board of trustees of the American Hospital Association, Chicago, Illinois, June 3, 1939. Hospitals, 1939, 13: 01-4- Minutes of the meetings of the Board of trustees of the American Hospital Association, Boston, Massachusetts, September 15, 16, 18, 19, 1940. Ibid., 1940, 14: No. 11, 58-63.— Minutes of the meeting of the Board of trustees of the American Hospital Association, 18 East Division Street. Chicago, Illinois, October 1, 1940. Ibid., 64 7.—Minutes of the meeting of the Board of trustees of the American Hospital Association. Ibid.. 1941, 15: No. 3, 68-73.—Mother Donovan. Biennial meeting of the Canadian Hospital Council, Monti enl, September 10-11, 1941. Hosp. Progr., 1942, 23: 40-3.—Nebraska Hospital Assembly. Hospi- tals, 1941, 15: No. 12, 59. -Neff, R. E. Hospitals and their relationship to the White House conference. Hosp. Social Serv., 1933, 27: 670-7.—Nuffield provincial hospitals trust; the Bristol conference. Brit. M. J., 1940, 2: 533.—Primer Con- greso de Hospitales, 13 de diciembre 1942, Bucaramanga, Colombia. Reforma m£d., Lima, 1942, 28: 166.— Program of the 42d annual convention of the American Hospital Associa- tion, Boston, Massachusetts, September 16-20, 1940. Hospitals 1940, 14: No. 8, 57-06.—Program (The) of the St Louis con- vention. Bull. Am. Hosp. Ass., 1935, 9: No. 9, 3-15.—Quarto (II) Congresso internazionale degli ospedali. Riv. osped., 1935, 25: 326-46.—Reazione sul Congresso inteniazionale degli ospedali. Osp. maggiore, Milano, 1937, 25: 414-7.—Resolu- tions adopted at the twenty-third annual convention of the Catholic Hospital Association of the United States and Canada. Hosp. Progr., 1938, 19: 227-33.—Resolutions adopted at the silver jubilee convention of the Catholic Hospital Association of the United States and Canada. Ibid., 1940, 21: 253-65.— Sand, R. Third International Hospital Congress. Nosokomeion, Stuttg., 1933, 4:137.—Schwitalla, A. M. The twentieth annual convention. Hosp. Progr., 1935, 16: 266-71. ------ The president's address at the 20th annual convention. Ibid., 323-30. ------ The twenty-fourth annual convention. Ibid., 1939. 20: 148-51. ------ The Silver Jubilee convention. Ibid., 1940, 21: 137-45. ------ The Silver Jubilee convention of the Catholic Hospital Association of the United States and Canada; the president's address. Ibid., 185-205. ------ The program of the twenty-seventh annual convention. Ibid 1942, 23: 131-3.—Silver (The) Jubilee convention [Catholic Hospital Association of the United States and Canada, St Louis, Missouri, June 17-18, 1940] Ibid., 1940, 21: 230-5.— Sister M. Evangeline. Report of the 26th annual convention of the Catholic Hospital Association of the United States and Canada. Ibid., 1942, 23: 43-5.—Sixth International Congress cancelled; no change in A. H. A. arrangements. Hosp. Manage- ment, 1939, 48: No. 3,13.—Sollazzo, G. Quarto Congresso inter- nazionale degli ospedali. Roma, 19-26 Maggio 1935. Osp maggiore, Milano, 1935, 23: 261-98.—Spinelli. S. ,Le parteci- pazione degli Istituti ospedalieri di Milano e del Sanatorio - Vittorio Emanuele III del comune di Milano in Garbagnate, al 'IV Congresso internazionale e alia mostra degli ospedali italiani in Roma, Ibid., 301-14.—Story (The) of the Atlantic City convention. Hospitals, 1941, 15: No. 10, 66-79.— Summary of the minutes of the Executive Board meeting of the Catholic Hospital Association of the United States and Canada Hosp. Progr., 1936, 17: 243-51.—Third (The) International Hospital Congress. Nosokomeion, Stuttg., 1933, 4: 548.— I'oronto meeting a great success in spite of difficulties created by war. Hosp. Management, 1939, 48: No. 4, 9.—Tri-State hospitals hold interesting assembly. Ibid., 1938, 45: No. 5, 27. Twelfth (The) annual convention of Association of Western Hospitals and the Fourteenth annual moeting of Western Conference of the Catholic, Hospital Association Hospitals, 1938, 12: No. 4, 109 II. Twenty-fifth anniversary marked by C. H. A. in silver jubilee convention. Hosp. Management, 1940. 50: No. 1, 17-9. Twenty-sixth annual convention of the Catholic Hospital Association of the United States and Canada. Hosp. Progr., 1941, 22: 160-6.—Western hospitals hold annual convention. Hospitals, 1941, 15: No. 4, 96-8.—Wirth J. Der Erste Internationale Krankcnhaus- kongress in Atlantic City, U. S. A. Zschr. ges. KrankenhauswesH 1929, 25: 619-26. ---- Periodicals. American Hospital Association. Bulletin Menasha, Wis., 1929- [America] United Presbyterian Women's Association of North America. Annual re- port fn. p.] 57: 1935- Connecticut General Hospital Society. Annual report. N. Haven, v.42, 1868-9. Englewood Hospital Association. Annual report. Englewood, 1896/97; 1888/89: 47., 1933/34. Missouri Pacific Hospital Association. Annual report. S. Louis, 18 (1930) 1931- New York, N. Y. Societe Francaise de Bienfaisance de New York et de l'H6pital Francais. Rapport annuel. N. Y., 82.-104., 1889/90-1911/12; 107.-132., 1914/15- New York, N. Y. Society of the Lying-In Hospital. Annual report. N. Y., 136 (1934) 1935. New York, N. Y. Society of the New York Hospital. Annual report. N. Y., v.69, 1939- ■----The society of the New York Hospital, 17J1-1921; a commemoration of the one hundred and fiftieth anniversary of the granting of its charter held in Trinity Church, New York, October 26, 1921. 96p. 8? N. Y., 1921. New York, N. Y. United Hospital Fund. Yearbook. N. Y., v.37, 1916- —-— Financial and statistical information relating to member hospitals. 28cm. [N. Y., 1940] Passaic Hospital Association. Annual report. Passaic, 42., 1934. Paterson General Hospital Association. Annual report of the executive committee and officers to the board of managers and members of the association. Paterson, v.17-22, 1887-92; v.24-30, 1895-1900- v.32, 1902; v.33, 1903. Roma. Societa Lancisiana degli Ospedali di Roma. Bollettino. Roma, v.26-28, 1906-8. HOSPITAL centenary gift book; stories, verses, and drawings contributed by notable writers and artists in aid of the centenary appeal of the Royal Manchester Children's Hospital, ed. by Robert Ollerenshaw. 254p. pl. 8: Lond., G. G. Harrap & Co. [1935] HOSPITAL construction principles and prac- tice; a handbook of practical information. 96p. 8? Chic, Crain pub. co. [1927] HOSPITAL construction [incl. planningl Berl, L. importance de l'amenagement dans le rendement therapeutique d'un sanatorium. 56p. 8? Par., 1936. Distel, H. Rationeller Krankenhaus-Bau. lOOp. 8? Stuttg., 1932. Hoffman, K. A model hospital, p.487-96. 25cm. [N. Y., 1900] Hospital construction principles and prac- tices; a handbook of practical information. 96p. 8? Chic. [1927] HOSPITAL CONSTRUCTION 825 HOSPITAL CONSTRUCTION Laroche, J. O. *Considerations d'ordre hygiSnique et d'ordre psychologique sur la con- struction et la disposition interieure des 6tablisse- ments hospitaliers. 45p. 8? Par., 1935. Ritter, H. Der Krankenhausbau der Gegen- wart im In- und Ausland; Wirtschaft, Organisa- tion und Technik. 102p. 4? Stuttg., 1932. Schachner, B. Krankenhausbau in Stich- worten und Skizzen. 60p. 8? Miinch., 1935. ---Schmieden, H., & Winterstein, H. Krankenhausbau. ix, 344p. 8? Berl., 1930. Schaerer, M. La construction des hopitaux modernes et leurs installations; ouvrage a l'usage des medecins, architectes, inggnieurs, techniciens, personnel d'administration, 6tudiants et prac- ticiens. 604p. 8? Par. [1930] Schmieden, H. Krankenshausbau in neuer Zeit. v. p. 4? Kirchhain [1930] Baldassari, L. DeU'ordinamento, della costruzione, del funzionamento economico degli istituti ospitalieri Nosoko- meion, Stuttg., 1938, 9: 227-30.—Bishop, H. E. Problems ronfronting administrators in new hospital construction Hospitals, 1930, 10: No. 3, 30-5.—Bordas, Schereschewsky & Rmere. Un hopital moderne. Ann. hyg., Par., 1933, n. ser., 11: 260-71.—Chapman, F. E. Development of a hospitai building program. Hosp. Progr., 1929, 10: 184-92.—Chisholm, J. A hospital builder. J. Obst. Gyn. Brit. Empire, 1939, 46: 389.—Distel, H. Moderner Krankenhausbau. Zschr. ' ges. Krankenhauswes., 1939, 137-43.—Elcock, C. E. Hospitai building; past, present and future. Proc. R. Soc. M Lond 1941-42, 35: 359-74.—Frank. H. Krankenhausrundschau" Deut. med. Wschr., 1939, 65: 1576-9.—Gentil, F. Construcoes hospitalares. Lisboa mid., 1933, 10: 621-49.—Goldwater, S. S. Introducing the chairman of the building committee' Mod. Hosp., 1927, 28: 49-52.—Heerman, R. E. Remodeling the hospital plant to improve service and reduce operating expenses^ Hospitals, 1941, 15: No. 4, 57-9.—Hildebrand, O. Jahresberichte von Krankenhausern, Krankenhausbau, etc Jahrber. Fortschr. Chir., 1917, 21: 651.—Hills, J. B. The architecture of the hospital. Hosp. Progr., 1939, 20: 369-77.— Holbrook, J. H. The ideal hospital of the future. Canad. M. Ass. J., 1932, 26: 189-94.—Hospital solves a housing prob- lem. Hosp. Topics, 1939,16: No. 9, 12.—Hospital and its archi- tect. Lancet, Lond., 1934, 1: 1356.—Howland, J. B. Report; Committee on hospital planning and equipment. Tr. Am. Hosp. Ass., 1931, 32: 447-62.—J, R. Which shall it be? Nurs. Times, Lond., 1941, 37: 683.—Kalinske, A. A., & King, F. R. Why take a chance? Mod. Hosp., 1937 48: No. 3, 100-4.—Kopp, E. Weg und Ziel des Krankenhausbaues. Deut. med. Wschr., 1934, 60: 31-4.—Lanchester, H. V. Modern hospital development. Irish J. M. Sc, 1932, No. 81, 561.—Lommel. Das Krankenhaus als Hochhaus. Zschr. ges. Krankenhauswes., 1920, 22: 449-51. ------ Alte und neue Forderungen im Krankenhausbau. Gesundh. Ignenieur, 1929, 52: 452-60.—Moore, D. B. D. K. The building of a hospital, 1804-1940. Irish J. M. Sc, 1941, 6. ser., No. 181, 1-6.—Munger, C. W. Report of the Committee on hospital planning and equipment. Tr. Am. Hosp. Ass., 1932, 34: 256-71.—Neergaard, C. F. Report of the Committee on hospital planning and equipment. Hospitals, 1936, 10: No. 2, 91-8. ------ A layman looks at a hospital. Mod. Hosp., 1936, 47: No. 2, 67.—New hospitals for old; the 1936 report of the A. H. A. Committee on hospital planning and equipment. Hospitals, 1937, 11: No. 2, 59-69.—Nichols, E. Depression ghost becomes a beautiful building. Mod. Hosp., 1939, 52: No. 6, 46-9.—Operation of hospital continued while entire wing is razed and rebuilt. Hosp. Management, 1941, 52: No. 5, 26-8.—Palhares, O. Evolucao das construcoes hos- pitalares. Arq. brasil. med. nav., 1941, 2: 493-501.—Piechaud, F., & Latier, M. Principes genfiraux de l'organisation et de la constructon de l'hopital en France. Nosokomeion, Stuttg., 1937, 8: 202-11.—Quervain, F. de. Ueber moderne Kranken- bausbauprobleme. Schweiz. med. Wschr., 1932, 62: 25-8.— R, N. P. The historical article. Brooklyn Hosp. J., 1941, 3: 65-7.—Responsible sources of supply in hospital construction, equipment, operation, and maintenance. Hosp. Progr., 1941, 22: Suppl., 1A.—Riley, W. A. Swedish research bureau proves valuable. Mod. Hosp., 1936, 46: No. 4, 80. —:---- Points to consider before building program is begun. Ibid., 1941, 56: No. 3, 66, ill.—Ritter, H. Erweiterung und Erneuerung von alten Krankenhausern. Zschr. ges. Krankenhauswes., 1938, 413-6.—Ronzani, E. Gli sviluppi dell'edifizia ospedaliera. Osp. maggiore, Milano, 1934, 22: 47-52.—Schmidt, K. Mo- derne Beschlage fiir Krankenhausbauten. Zschr. ges. Kranken- hauswes., 1938, 97-9.—Schonleber, A. Gedanken uber Erfahrungen, die sich durch die Besichtigung alterer Kranken- anstalten fiir eigene Bauvorhaben gewinnen lassen konnen unter besonderer Berucksichtigung der Verhaltnisse des stadtischen Krankenhauses Sachsenhausen in Frankfurt am Main. Ibid., 257-9.—Setz, M. Baugestaltende Forderungen fur die Leistungen am Kranken im Krankenhaus. Gesundh. Ingenieur, 1934, 57: 535; 544.—Sloan, R. P. As long as we have a roof. Mod. Hosp., 1936, 46: No. 3, 46-50. ------ ni. i, n dwgSrf?r ?1,d" Jhld" 47: No- 3- 44-8.-Smelzer, D. C, lilack, B. W. [et al.] Council on Hospital Planning and Plant Operation, annual report 1938. Tr. Am. Hosp. Ass., 1938, 40: »*•—»P|nelli, S. Gli ospedali e l'imposta di consumo sui material! da costruzione. Osp. maggiore, Milano, 1938, 26: 232-5—Sturzenacker. Moderner Krankenhausbau. Zschr ges. Krankenhauswes., 1938, 65-8.—Tipping, K. V. Hospital planning and renovation. Tr. Am. Hosp. Ass., 1938, 40: »'l-7.—Velden, R- von den. Reflexiones mgdicas sobre la construccidn de hospitales. Rev. mid. germ. iber. amer., 1935 • O'":1.0-—Walter, J. A propos de la modernisation d'un ancien h6pital. Nosokomeion, Stuttg., 1938, 9: 231 —Wilson L R., Black, B. W. [et al.] Council on Hospital Planning and llant Operation, annual report 1939. Tr. Am. Hosp. Ass., 1939, 41: 105—7. ---- Air conditioning. American Hospital Association. Report of the committee on air-conditioning. 9p. 8? Chic, Am. Hosp. Ass., 1934. Andre, J. R. *Etude de l'aeration dans les salles d'hopital et les 6coles. 54p. 8? Par., 1931. Young, A. G. The status of hospital air con- ditioning. 6p. 4? N. Y., 1938. Air purification by hypochlorous acid gas. Med. Press & Circ, Lond., 1940, 203: 295.—Appleton, W. C. What is happening in air conditioning? Hospitals, 1942, 16: No. 5, 62.—Bishop, H. E. Hospitals benefit in 5 ways by air conditioning. Hosp. Management, 1936, 41: 20-2. ------ Hospitals benefit in 5 ways from air conditioning; comfort for patients, personnel; removal of odors; proper humidity; cleansing of air; reduction of noise and dirt among advantages. Ibid., 1934, 38: 19-22.— Brandi, O. H. Klima-Anlagen im Krankenhausbau. Nosokomeion, Stuttg., 1936, 7: 46-9.— Brisbane, R. D. Specifications for air conditioning equipment for Sutter Hospital. Hospitals, 1930, 10: 76-82. ------ Air conditioning in 52 bed hospital. Mod. Hosp., 1939, 53: No. 1, 52.—Case (The) for air conditioning. Ibid., 1938, 50: No 4, 81-4.—Desfosses P. Une revolution hospitahere; aeration et Constance de la temperature dans les salles d'hopi- taux. Presse med., 1927, 35: 315.—Febderber, M. B., Rosen- berg, A. A., & Houghten, F. C. Physiological aspects of air conditioning. Mod. Hosp., 1939, 53: 54-7.—Frid, V. A. Some factors affecting hospital air conditioning. Hosp. Management, 1938, 46 No. 6, 16. ------ Hospital air conditioning. Bull. Am. Coll. Surgeons, 1939, 24: 188.— Frommelt, H. A. Equipment for hospital air conditioning. Hosp. Progr., 1935, 16: 155-7.—Hahn, W. Zeitgemasse Beliiftungsanlagen fur Krankenhaus- und Anstaltsbetriebe. Zschr. ges. Krankenhauswes., 1939, 258-61.—Henderson, W. B. Advantages of air conditioning both therapeutic and financial. Hosp. Management, 1939, 48: No. 2, 22. Also in Hosp. Admin. & Org. (Hosp. Management) Chic, 1942, 49.—Hosrner, M. N. Observations on patients in air condi- tioned hospital rooms. Hospitals, 1936, 10: 87-9.—Hospital air conditioning. J. Am. M. Ass., 1937, 108: 558.—Innovations in equipment feature new air-conditioned nursery. Hosp. Management, 1939, 48: No. 1, 11.—Jarrett, L. E. Angles on air conditioning; good practices and bad. Mod. Hosp., 1941, 56: No. 4, 88.—Jones, J. P., & Phillips, V. B. Air conditioning for hospitals. Ibid., 1936, 47: No. 5, 76-83.—Kirchberg, F., & Thierbach, B. Kiinstliche Khmahaltung; Verwendung der Elektrizitat im Krankenhaus. Zschr. ges. Krankenhauswes., 1934, 533-7.—KraissI, C. J. Discussion of the paper by E. C. Robertson, Ultraviolet light in hospital practice. Tr. Am. Hosp. Ass., 1939, 41: 575-7.—Linke, F. Luftung, Klimati- sieung und Luftfilterung in Krankenhausern. Zschr. ges. Krankenhauswes., 1934, 509-18.—MacQuiddy, E. L. A study in hospital air conditioning. Hospitals, 1936, 10: 93-6.— Mills, A. B. Air conditioning at slight expense. Mod. Hosp., 1936, 47: No. 6, 83.—Morrill, W. P. The physics of humidity control. Hospitals, 1938, 12: No. 11, 48— Muhleman, R. F. Benefits of hospital air conditioning of interest to administra- tors and medical profession. Hosp. Management, 1941, 51: No. 2, 72.—Munger, C. W., Stephenson, M. V. [et al.] Report of the Committee on Air Conditioning, 1936. Tr. Am. Hosp. Ass., 1936, 38: 176-83.— Naeslund, C. Ueber die Frage der Liiftung des Krankenhauses. Upsala lak. foren. forh., 1931, n. f., 36: 375-96.—Neergaard, C. F. A trustee considers air conditioning. Mod. Hosp., 1939, 53: No. 1, 60-3.------ The realistic approach to hospital air conditioning. Hosp. Progr., 1940, 21: 17-21.—Neisser. Die Luftungsfrage. Zschr. ges. Krankenhauswes., 1927, 23: 711-6.—Olstad, M. H. Conditioning of air in hospitals; adaptability, efficiency, con- struction costs, and maintenance. Tr. Am. Hosp. Ass., 1931, 33: 336-45.—Petersen, W. F. The patient and air condition- ing; a discussion of the physiological basis of air conditioning. Hosp. Progr., 1939, 20: 317-27.—Petrick. Wo stehen wir heute in der Frage der Krankenzimmerliiftung? Zschr. ges. Krankenhauswes., 1931, 245-51.------ Luft und Licht im Krankenhaus. Ibid., 1933, 544; 1934, 224.------ Die neuen Bichtlinien iiber die Luftung im Krankenhaus. Ge- sundh. Ingenieur, 1936, 59: 513-6. ------ Die Luftung des Krankenzimmers. Zschr. ges. Krankenhauswes., 1936, 99- 102.—Realistic (the) approach to hospital air conditioning. Hosp. Topics, 1940, 18: 14.—Schmidt, O. Eine neue Fens- HOSPITAL CONSTRUCTION 826 HOSPITAL CONSTRK TION terlilftung fiir Krankenriiume. Zschr. ges. Krankenhauswes.. 1935, 5S2-4.- Schrocder. F. ITeber Luftfeucbtigkcitsmessung und -regelung im Krankenhaus. Ibid., 1937, 551 3.—Schuni, H. Die neue Klimaanlagc im Operationssaal des Stuats- krankenhauscs dir l.andespolizei. Chirurg, Beil., 1935, 7: 115-23.—Setz, M. Die Luftung und kiinstliche Bewctteruiife des Krankenhauses. Gesundh. Ingenieur, 1935, 58: 305-9.- Sheard. C. Air conditioning; its uses and limitations in clinici and hospitals. Collect. Papers Mayo Clin. (1940) 1941, 32; 1033-42. Also Hospitals, 1941, 15: No. 7, 102-12.—Significant tests reveal essential importance of air purification. Hosp. Management, 1942, 53: No. 5, 83.—Status of refrigeration and air-condiiinning in 110 hospitals. Ibid., 1936, 41: 22.— Stevens, E. F. Air conditioning or power plant ol the hospital. Hospitals. 1937. 11: No. 5, 74-85.—Swern, P. W. Air condi- tioning in hospitals. Ibid., No. 12, 08.—Tchijevsky, A. L. La salle d'hopital cuirass6e pour la protection des malades contre les radiations solaires et cosmiques nuisibles. Gaz. hop., 1937, 110: 221-4.—Trincas, M. L'utiliU dell'aria condizionata negli ospedali in A. O. Clinica, Bologna, 1936, 2: 194-200.—Uglov, V. A. [Ventilation in hospitals] Soviet. vrach. J., 1936, 1: 59-63.—Watt, J. The ventilation, heating and lighting of hospital wards. Proc R. Soc. M., Lond., 1933, 26: Sect. Epid., 1411-26.—Whitaker, E. C. Air conditioning; a. luxury or a necessity? Hospitals, 1937, 11: No. 7, 82-4.— Wilson, L. R. Air conditioning. Ibid., 1938, 12: No. 12, 83. ------ Ayer, F. [et al.] Report of the Committee on Air Conditioning, 1937. Tr. Am. Hosp. Ass., 1937, 39: 60-4 — Wyatt, B. L. Our first year's experience with air conditioning. Mod. Hosp., 1 935, 45: No. 5, 49.—Yaglou, C. P. Hospital air conditioning. J. Indust. Hvg., 1936, 18: 741-66. Also in Environment &c (Harvard Univ.) Bost., 1937, 244-69. Also J. Am. M. Ass., 1938, 110: 2003-9. ------ Advantages and limitations of hospital air conditioning. Mod. Hosp., 1939, 53: No. 1, 50.—Young, A. G. To what extent should hospitals use air conditioning? Hosp. Management, 1939, 47: No. 5, 26. Also in Hosp. Admin. & Org. (Hosp. Manage- ment) Chic, 1942, 46-8. ------ Hospital air conditioning. In Hosp. Yearb., 1941, 19: 981-3. ---- Call system. Alter, W. Die Wunschruf-Anlage im Krankenhaus. Noso- komeion, Stuttg., 1938, 9: 140-5.—Jaekel, W. Ncuartige Lichtrufanlagen fiir Krankenhauser. Zschr. ges. Kranken- hauswes., 1938, 180-2.—Lentz, C. S. Ticker svstem. Tr. Am. Hosp. Ass., 1936, 38: 318-21.— Myers, C. W. Lamp flashing system. Ibid., 321-30.—Willet, G. R. Hospital paging systems, a symposium; loud speaking system. Ibid., 316-8. Also Hospitals, 1937, 11: No. 1, 80-5. ---- Cost. Alter. Das wohlfeile Krankenhaus. Zschr. ges. Kranken- hauswes., 1931, 57-61.—Caffrey, J. G. Financing and modern- ization of hospitals under the Federal Housing Administration. Tr. Am. Hosp. Ass., 1930, 38: 505-9.—Distel, H.. Die na- tionale und regionale Planwirtschaft im Krankenhausbau. Nosokomeion, Stuttg., 1937, 8: 37-44.—Dosquet, W. Ueber Aufbau und Betrieb von Krankenanstalten in wirtschaftlich bedrangter Zeit. Deut. Zschr. off. Gesundhptl., 1925-26, 2: 153-69.—Eleven million-dollar building program nears com- pletion in Michigan. Hosp. Management, 1941, 51: 22, illust.—Fifty-bed hospital built, equippi'd for $2,042 per bed. Ibid., 1934, 37: 28.—Hannaford, H. E. Low building costs offer rare chance to remodel the hospital. Mod. Hosp., 1934, 42: 82-4.—Hospitals to spend $357,750,000 for modernization in 1940. Hosp. Management, 1940, 49: No. 2, 15.—Maybee, H. V. How much money does it take to start a plan? Tr Am. Hosp. Ass., 1938, 40: 698.—Neergaard, C. F. Economics of hospital planning. Hosp. Progr., 1927, 8: 315-20.—Philips- born, A. Beschrankungen bei Grundstiickserwerb, Zuwen- dungen und Anleihen. Jahrb. ges. Krankenhauswes., 1932, 1: Teil 2, 1-7.—Rendschmidt. Baukosten-Statistik fiir Kranken- hauser. Zschr. ges. Krankenhauswes., 1932, 8-12.—Roosevelt Hospital plans new $2,000,000 structure. Hosp. Management 1939, 47: No. 4, 21.—Rorem, C. R. Hospitals of U. S. repre- sent a $3,000,000 investment. Ibid., 1930, 30: 42-6.—Schum, H. Ist der grundliche Umbau eines veralteten Krankenhauses vom wirtschaftlichen und arztlichen Standpunkt aus gerecht- fertigt? Zschr. ges. Krankenhauswes., 1936, 128-32.—Schwi- talla, A. M., & Kneifl, M. R. The renovation of our hospitals and the Emergency relief appropriation act. Hosp. Progr 1935, 16: 312-4.—Van Arsdall, H. P. How ceiling height affects cost of hospital construction. Hosp. Management 1926, 22: No. 4, 43. ---- Decoration. Art in the hospital. Hosp. Topics, 1938, 16: No. 5, 20.— Birren, F. Functional color in hospitals. Mod. Hosp., 1939, 53: No. 5, 65.—Blank, F. J. Color plays therapeutic role in hospital interiors. Hosp. Management, 1942, 53: No. 4, 55-60.—Bradley, F. R. Hospital painting. Hospitals, 1936^ 10: No. 1, 85-9.—Connick, C. J. Stained glass windows. Mod. Hosp., 1940, 55: No. 3, 65-7, pl.—Crodel, W., & Schaefler, M. F. Farben im Krankenhause. Zschr. ges. Krankenhaus- wes., 1929, 25: 466; 492.—Goodfriend, J. More paint less maintenance. Mod. Hosp., 1938, 51: No. 6, 78.—Hospital murals. Trained Nurse, 1941, 107: 100-2.—Johnson, R. Decorative effect of hospital room aided by proper selection of colors and curtains. Hosp. Management, 1911, 52: No. (',, 55-8.—-King, F. Let's have color. In Hosp. Admin, it Org. fllosp. .Management) Chic, 1942, 42. — -—• Modernizing patients' accommodations on a limited budget. Ibid., 44.— Kirchmann, F. Welche Farbanstriche sind fur Kranken- und tleilanstalten vorteilhaft? Zschr. ges. Krankenhauswes., 1934, 566.- Kegel, M. D. An interpretation of the Palmer murals. Hospitals. 1938, 12: 27-37.—McCleery, A. B. Mod- ernization and decoration. Ibid., 1939, 13: No. 10, 61-3.— Mears, B. W. Color in the hospital. Ibid., 1937, LI: No. 10 100. Also Tr. Am. Hosp. Ass., 1937, 39: 089-94.—Paintings (The) of Hogarth on the staircase leading to the Great Hall, St Bartholomew's Hospital. S. Barth. Hosp. J., Lond., 1934-35, 42: 99-101.—Poltavtsev, A. N. I Reserve medical hospital fund for redecorations] Sovet. med., 1938, No. 23, 13-0.—Sister Agnita Miriam. The romance of remodeling. Hosp. Progr., 1942, 23: 92-5.—Sister M. Lucilia. Introducing color in private patients' rooms. In Hosp. Admin. & Org. (Hosp. Management) Chic, 1942, 50.—Sloan, R. P. Color in the hospital. In Hosp. Yearb., 1941, 19: 935-8.—Stein, B. In- terior decorating in the hospital. Hosp. Management, 1938 46: 43-5. ---- Depreciation, and errors in construction. Albert, B. Fehler im Krankenhausbau. Nosokomeion Stuttg., 1934, 5: 119-27.—Erikson, C. A. Sick hospitals; their diagnosis and therapy. In Hosp. Yearb., 1941, 19: 929.— Foster, M. H. Avoiding mistakes in building. Mod. Hosp., 1937, 48: No. 3, 89-91.—Lome, F. Errors in the technical equipment and plant in the hospital. Nosokomeion, Stuttg., 1933, 4: 522-45.—Lundy, V. R., & Crawford, L. L. Deprecia- tion in hospital buildings. J. Am. M. Ass., 1939, 113: 2326.— Smith, J. M. A new hospital; 5 years later. Mod. Hosp., 1934, 42: 45-51.—Walker, F. M. Common errors in hospital construction. Tr. Am. Hosp. Ass., 1931, 32: 462-9. ---- Drainage. Alt, H. L. New Manchurian Hospital has excellent plumb- ing system. Ho.sp. Management, 1926, 21: No. 4, 34-8.— Alter. Krankenhaus und Gesundheitsingenieur. Gesundh. Ingenieur, 1930, 53: 417-25; 1939, 62: 445-50.—Barons, K. Zur Frage der Sanatorien- und Krankenhauserkanalisation in Lettland. Nosokomeion, Stuttg., 1937, 8: 243-5.—Bundesen, H. N. Health hazards in plumbing. Mod. Hosp., 1935, 44: 71-4.—Stine, L. B. Fundamentals on the care of hospital plumbing. Hosp. Management, 1935, 40: 20-8.—Wagner, E. G. Housekeeper studies plumbing. Mod. Hosp., 1940, 55: No. 6, 100. ---- Equipment. Alter. Technische Verbesserungen und Neuerungen im Krankenhaus. Gesundh. Ingenieur, 1927, 50: 21-4.—Angle, J. L. Four factors are important in the selection of hospital furniture. Hosp. Management, 1940, 49: No. 4, 53-8. Also in Hosp. Admin. & Org. (Hosp. Management) Chic, 1942, 63-5.—Bos, A. C. [Equipment of a colonial hospital] Zie- kenhuis, 1928, 19: 162-4.—Bowman, C. N. Application of copper pipe to hospital maintenance. Hosp. Management, 1940, 50: No. 2, 53—Brandau, A. Die Wirtschaftlichkeit Dosquetscher Fensteranlagen. Zschr. ges. Krankenhauswes., 1929, 25: 241-3.—Complete array of hospital equipment to be exhibited at Boston convention. Hosp. Management, 1940, 50: No. 3, 22.—Crawford, J. S. Proper hospital equipment; a sound investment. North Am. Vet., 1939, 20: No. 6, 48-52.— Directory of exhibitors at the silver jubilee convention of the C. H. A. Hosp. Progr., 1940, 21: 175-80.—Farrar, B. The built-in equipment in hospital construction. Ibid., 11—4.—■ Fine, R. L. Rubber in today's hospital. Hosp. Management, 1935, 40: No. 5, 19-21.—Freund, W. Gesundheitstechnische Einrichtungen eines Bezirkskrankenhauses. Zschr. ges. Krankenhauswes., 1926, 22: 202-9.—Gregoire, J. F. Hospital planning in relation to equipment; the surgical suite. Hosp. Progr., 1927, 8: 224-30.—Hannaford, H. E. Hospital elevators. Hospitals, 1936, 10: No. 1, 54-6.—Hospital trolley fitted witli emergency apparatus. Brit. M. J., 1935, 2: 344.—Hygiene publique. Mouvement hyg., Brux., 1909, 25: 34 -9.—Interna- tional Hospital Association; permanent committee for the study of hospital equipment. Nosokomeion, Stuttg., 1932, 3: 338.—Janzen, A. W. Establishing specifications for food service equipment. Hosp. Management, 1939, 48: No. 6, 45.—Korte, F. Zweckmassigste Verlegung der verschiedenen Leitungen im Krankenhausbau? Zschr. ges. Krankenhauswes., 1927, 23: 41.—Lenzi, G. floors, windows and doors in hospi- tals. Nosokomeion, Stuttg., 1938, 9: 128-36.—Linke, F. Das Forderband im Krankenhauswesen; Convevor, SvIaiwh Zschr. ges. Krankenhauswes., 1929, 25: 15--7.—Lorenz, H. Das Krankenbett. Ibid., 1928, 24: 367.—McGaw, F. G. Patient's welfare prime objective in creation of new equipment. Hosp. Management, 1941, 51: No. 2, 24.—Mench, J. G. Wesley's mechanical systems. Mod. Hosp., 1942, 58: 54-7.—' Neergaard, C. F. Simplified hospital hardware. Ibid., 1926, 27: No. 3, 48-50.—Nunziata, A. Curaciones; modelo de carrito. Sem. m6d., B. Air., 1939, 46: pt 1, 680-3.—Olson, G. W. Innovations in hospital equipment and supplies. Bull. Am. Coll. Surgeons, 1930, 21: 27. Peterkin, J. Latest equipment, efficient layout feature Chicago hospital. Mod. Hosp., 1933, HOSPITAL CONSTRUCTION 827 HOSPITAL CONSTRUCTION 40: 63-70.—Russell, H. C. Laundry, kitchen and hospital equipment. Tr. Am. Soc Heat. Ventil. Engin., 1929, 35: 45-76.—Schier, J. Postschalter in Krankenanstalten. Zschr. ges. Krankenhauswes., 1929, 25: 505. ------ Die Verchro- mung von Gegenstanden und ihre Verwendung im Kranken- hausbetrieb. Ibid., 1930, 123.—Sculky, C. Selecting silver- ware. Mod. Hosp., 1941, 56: No. 2, 94-6— Sister Mary Loyola. Equipping the small department. Ibid., 57: No. 5, 96, plan.—Streit, S. Selection and maintenance of institutional equipment. Tr. Am. Hosp. Ass.. 1938, 40: 165-8.—Temper. Die Sonderschau Das Krankenhaus auf der Internationalen Hygiene-Ausstellung Dresden 1930. Zschr. ges. Kranken- hauswes., 1930, 259.—Thomas, G. I. The beverage counter. Trained Nurse, 1941, 107: 125.—Voges. Autex-Ergebnisse. Zschr. ges. Krankenhauswes., 1926. 22: 339-41.—Walsh, W. H. What constitutes hospital equipment. Hosp. Progr., 1931, 12: 114-23. ------ Modern trends in hospital planning and equipment. Hospitals, 1940, 14: No. 7, 77; No. 8, 76; No. 9, 79. Also repr.—Warehouse handling equipment. Mod. Hosp., 1942, 58: 80.—When it's time to furnish the new wing. Ibid 1930, No. 3, 46: 84.—Which mat shall I buy? Hosp. Manage- ment, 1936, 42: 30; 61.—Williams, H. B. Medical equipment on the air. Mod. Hosp., 1939, 53: No. 3, 79.—Williams, H. S. A sanatorium spruces up. Ibid., 1938, 51: No. 2, 48-51.— Wohlfahrt, S. [Hospital details] Sven. lak. tidn., 1935, 32: 305-7. --- Floor. Chapman, F. E. Report of the committee on floors, submitted at the annual conference, Atlantic City, September 25th to 30th, 1922. 20p. 8? Chic, 1922. Geister, C. H. Condition of floors after continued service. 8p. 8? [Chic] 1925. Coleman, M. H., jr. Maintenance and renovation of original floors. Tr. Am. Hosp. Ass., 1936, 38: 330-2.—Device for test- ing waxed floors an aid to efficient maintenance. Hosp. Management, 1941, 52: No. 4, 73.—Flikeid, J. What to do about floors. Mod. Hosp., 1937, 48: No. 4, 83-5.—Jenkins, J. W. A functional floor surface. Ibid., 1942, 58: No. 3, 88 — Mallmann, W. L. A bacteriologic study of a new sanigenic flooring. J. Am. M. Ass., 1941, 117: 844-7.—Marsh, H. H. Electrical flexibility provided by cellular steel floor. Mod. Hosp., 1935, 44: 102-4.—Micksch, K. Das Linoleum in der Heilanstalt. Zschr. ges. Krankenhauswes., 1928, 24: 341-3.— Neergaard, C. F. Floor plan requirements. Hospitals, 1940, 14: No. 1, 27-31.—Page, M. G. We treat the floors. .Mod. Hosp., 1938, 50: No. 3, 96.—Stone, C. G. Conductivity tests on samples of terrazzo floors. Hospitals, 1941, 15: No. 6, 88.— Walsh, W. H. Rubber flooring. Tr. Am. Hosp. Ass., 1936, 38:337-9.—Widmer, A. J. Floor plans of the hospital. Hosp. Progr., 1940, 21: 392-400.—Wilson, L. R. Mastic tile flooring. Tr. Am. Hosp. Ass., 1936, 38: 332. ------ Facts on floors. Mod. Hosp., 1938, 50: No. 6, 82-4.—Wood, G. U. Linoleum. Tr. Am. Hosp. Ass., 1936, 38: 333-7. --- Geography. Grober, J. Das deutsche Krankenhaus: Handbuch fiir Bau, Einrichtung und Betrieb der Krankenanstalten. 3. Aufl. 1002p. 8? Jena, 1932. Adams, H. P. English hospital planning. Brit. M. J., 1929, 1: 1173. Also J. R. Nav. M. Serv.. 1930, 16: 10-22.—Air view of the John Sealy Hospital and the School of Medicine of the University of Texas. Bull. John Sealy Hosp., Galvest., 1939, 1: 93.—Anscombe, E. M. The Jewish Hospital of St Louis innovation in construction. Hosp. Management, 1926, 22: No. 2, 25-33.—Betts, L. Reconstruction of the Ellis Hospital, Schenectady, N. Y. Albany M. Ass., 1938, 57: 20.— Bischof, J. Das neue Kreiskrankenhaus in Prenzlau Um. Zschr. ges. Krankenhauswes., 1927, 23: 747-50.—Bishop, H. E. Packer Hospital flexible in design. Mod. Hosp., 1935, 44: 47-51.—Bohmer, F., & Petrich, G. Der Erweiterungsbau des Grafin Rittberg-Krankenhauses in Berlin-Lichterfelde. Zschr. ges. Krankenhauswes., 1937, 181-0.—JBubenhofer. Der Neu- bau des Bezirkskrankenhauses in Freudenstadt i. Schw. Ibid., 1927, 23: 571-7.—Buffalo Bill's town builds a hospital. Hosp. Topics, 1940, 18: No. 10, 12.—C, M. K. The Freemasons' New Hospital. Nurs. Times, Lond., 1933, 29: 688-90 — Cederstrom, H. Das geplante neue Zentralkrankenhaus in Stockholm. Deut, med. Wschr., 1937, 63: 524.—Chueco, A. La edifieacion del Hospital Juan A. Fernandez. Sem. mid., B. Air., 1933, 40: pt 2, 1627-47.—Davis, N. E. Presenting Alton Memorial Hospital. Mod. Hosp., 1940, 54: No. 5, 78, illust., plan.—Deaconess Hospital, Detroit, presents its latest addi- tion for your inspection. Ibid., 1939, 53: No. 6, 62, illust,— Dix. Die Erweiterungsbauten in den stadtischen Kranken- hausern in Leipzig zu schnellster Beseitigung vorhandener Raumnote. Zschr. ges. Krankenhauswes., 1926, 22: 72-5.— Douglas and Morenci; Arizona's twin"hospitals. Mod. Hosp., 1940, 55: No. 6, 66-8.—DuPont, A. V. New Delaware Hospi- tal features design for management. Hosp. Management, 1941, 52: No. 3, 28-31, illust., plans.—Durand. L'Hopital de Grange- Blanche. Lyon med., 1934, 153: 641-72, 2 diagr.—Durie, F. S. U. of C. O P. D. building planned for 200 000 visits- enr responding hospital departments on same floor with clinic departments; dental unit has 80-chair operative divfsZ Hosp. Management, 1934, 37: 38.-Ehrler. Die KlinTw 192^4? W^F." B,TW |schr. ges. Krankenhauswe", 1928, 24. 59-61.—Elcock, C. E. The present position of hospi- tal planning and construction in Great Britain and Ireland rrTs? CW'- St^".+19,31. 2: H32-41, 2 diagr.-EnnekiS: 1 Ihe St Canisius Hospitai in Nimwegen] Ziekenhuis, 1927, 18- ir ' 19/-1_E"ks"n- C- A-' Goldwater, S. S. [et al.) Montefiore felt9QeMb°dir Sri£nK rtr«ctural features. Vod° Hosp 1927, 29 No. 1, 57-66- Fvmeniev. N. V. [New hosnita construction Profil. med., Kharkov, 1927, 6: No 2 82-95- ^r™?!''1 Banatoriali di.Imperiil Osp. maggiore, Milano, 93., 23: 609-14 —laxon, N. W. The George Robert White building of the Massachusetts General Hospital. Harvard M. Alumni Bull. 1939-40, 14: 27, illust.-Fonio, A. Der Erweitel rungsbau am Bezirkskrankenhaus in Langnau bei Bern Zschr ges Krankenhauswes 1928, 24: 711-3.—Franklin, J. B. Rehabilitation of Grady hospital. Hospitals, 1936, 10: No 3 61-4.—Frey, H. Ein Gang durch Pariser Spitaler. Zschr. ges' Krankenhauswes., 1930, 305-9.—Gerritsen. H. A. [The Famaer clinic in Loosduinen] Ziekenhuis, 1927 18- 2-7__ Hebebrand. Krankenhausbau in den neuen Indiistriezentren der Sowjetunion. Zschr. ges. Krankenhauswes., 1933 565- 70.—Helmle, H. R. Million-dollar addition completed at St Johns Hospital. Hosp. Management, 1939, 48: No 6 12 illust —Helsted, A. [Description of new hospital at Gentofte] Ugeskr. laeger, 1927, 89: 101-5.—Hinenburg, M., & Good- friend, J. What has been achieved at Montefiore through modernization. Mod. Hosp., 1931, 36: 49; 87.—Hoeve, A. H van der [The Bartholomew Hospital in Utrecht] Ziekenhuis! 1928, 19: 59.—Hospital das chnicas da Faculdade de medicina de Sao Paulo. Rev. politecn., S. Paulo, 1940, 36: 127-40, plans.—Hospital (El) Hipolito Unanue y la opinion de la comisi6n tecnica encargada de su estudio. Reforma med Lima, 1937, 23: 492-6.—Huge New York hospital, Cornell Medical Center opened; institution will have daily population of 3 000; 11 buildings in unit, including 27-story main hospital block with divisions for private patients, for ward patients, and for employes' quarters. Hosp. Management, 1932 34: 26.—Hume, C. A. Delaware Hospital rebuilds. Mod. Hosp 1941, 56: No. 6, 47-50, illust., plans.—Hybbinette, S. [Remi- niscences: report on the proposed new Central Hospital of the south part of the city] Sven. lak. tidn., 1937, 34: 97-104.— Inauguracion de un hospital. Prensa mid. argent., 1939 26: pt 1, 392-8.—Jacobs, W. F., & Robbins, E. F. Bellevue still builds. Mod. Hosp., 1937, 48: No. 6, 62-4.—Klutho, V. J. St Mary's marks golden anniversary with a new plant. Ibid., 1933, 41: 53-8.—Kypke-Burchardi. Das Kreiskrankenhaus in Dramburg (Pomm.) Techn. Gemeindebl., 1928-29, 31: 49- 51.—Lang, R. Der Krankenhausbau im Dritten Reich. Zschr. ges. Krankenhauswes., 1934, 25-8.—Labores (Las) de la comision 1,6cnica sobre el hospital Unanue. Reforma m6d., Lima, 1937, 23: 588.—Lee, A. I,. Practical planning and mod- ern equipment feature New Jamaica Hospital. Mod. Hosp 1926, 27: 71-4.—Lemke, K. Die neuen Klinikbauten in Freiburg i. Br. Zschr. ges. Krankenhauswes., 1936, 298- 301.—Lommel, A. Die letzte Entwicklung und der heutige Stand des Krankenhausbaues in Deutschland und Oesterreich. Nosokomeion, Stuttg., 1931, 2: 1173-87.—Meurer. Die Modernisierung des stadtischen Krankenhauses am Friedrichs- hain zu Berlin. Zschr. ges. Krankenhauswes., 1928, 24: 307- 10. ------ Neubauten im Krankenhaus am Friedrichshain in Berlin. Ibid., 1929, 25: 203-7.—Miller, V. Henrotin blends beauty and service. Mod. Hosp., 1935, 44: 47-52.—Mills, Rhines [et al.] Magruder Memorial Hospital, Fort Clinton, Ohio. Ibid., 1941, 56: 55, plans.—Minchew, B. H., Mooney, A. J. [et al.] Cooperative planning in the building and opera- tion of community hospitals in Georgia. J. M. Ass. Georgia, 1940, 29: 356-67.—Modern hospital construction in Germany. Brit. M. J., 1936, 1: 709.—Mostra (La) dell'Ospedale Maggiore. Osp. maggiore, Milano, 1935, 23: 597-608.—Muller, R. Das Stadtische Kranken- und Pflegehaus zu Braunschweig. Zschr. ges. Krankenhauswes., 1927, 23: 625-30.—Neergaard, C. F. Hagerstown's new hospital. Hospitals, 1936, 10: No. 1, 26- 31.—New acute unit of the Los Angeles County General Hospi- tal completed. West. Hosp. Rev., 1933, 21: 11-7.—New (The) St George's. Lancet, Lond., 1939, 1: 599, picture.—New wing of St John's Hospital has many innovations. Hosp. Manage- ment, 1926, 22: No. 2, 52; 55.—Nieuwerkerk, F. [The new buildings of the hospital H. Joannes de Deo at the Hague erected from 1913 to 1928] Ziekenhuis, 1928, 19: 187-93 — Nosocomios (Los) modernos; el hospital Nestl6 de Lausana, Reforma mid., Lima, 1936, 22: 350-2.—Notre Dame completes new student infirmary. Hosp. Management, 1936, 41: 23; 64.—Nuevas (Las) construcciones hospitalarias de la comuna. Dia med., B. Air., 1939, 11: 248. illust,—Orbaan, C. [The St Joan's Hospital at Goes] Ziekenhuis, 1928, 19: 83.—Pesch, J. Das Katholische Krankenhaus (Philippusstift) in Essen- Borbeck. Zschr. ges. Krankenhauswes., 1926, 22: 199-202 — Peuckert & Lenz. Der Erweiterungsbau des Diakonissen- krankenhauses zu Kreuzburg, ein Beispiel der Erneuerung mittelgrosser Krankenhauser. Ibid., 1927, 23: 403-5.— Piechaud, F. La construction hospitahere en France. Bol. Of. san. panamer., 1940, 19: 351-7.—Portfolioof plans; Municipal Hospital, Iowa Falls, Iowa. Mod. Hosp., 1936, 46: No. 3, 57.—Portfolio of plans; New Woodlawn Hospital, Rochester, Ind. Ibid., 61.—Portfolio of plans; Ripon Municipal Hospital, HOSPITAL CONSTRUCTION 828 HOSPITAL CONSTRUCTION Ripon, Wis. Ibid., 62.—Portfolio of plans; Smith-Esteb Memorial Hospital, Richmond, Ind. Ibid., 54.—Portfolio of plans; Snyder "General Hospital, Snyder, Tex. Ibid., 64.— Portfolio of plans; Wilson Hospital, Wink, Tex. Ibid., 55.— Portfolio of plans; The Zurbrugg Hospital, Riverside, N. J. Ibid., 58.—Proposte di progetto di un nuovo ospcdale centrale :i St.oeeolma. Osp. maggiore, Milano, 1937, 25: 265-72.— Reiley. R. J. Modernizing St Clare's. Mod. Hosp., 1939, 53: No. 3, 5.")-7.—Resler, R., & O'Hanlon, G. Lutheran Hospital plan fitted to meet 4 major considerations. Hosp. Manage- ment, 1927, 23: No. 6, 27-32.—Rice, C. E. Porter Sanitarium, 100 beds, erected at cost of $2,400 per bed; spacious hydro- therapy department among features of newest Seventh-Day Adventist Institution. Ibid., 1930, 29: 26-9.—Riforma (La) e l'ampliamento edilizio dell'Ospedale di Uddenwalla in Svezia. Osp. maggiore, Milano, 1937, 25: 552-4.—Ronzani, E. La construction hospitalise en Italic Nosokomeion, Stuttg., 1934, 5: 219-23.—Rossi, E. Progetto dell'Ospedale clinico di Modena. Osp. maggiore, Milano, 1934, 22: 307-14.—Ruppel, F. Das Allgemeine Krankenhaus Hamburg-Barmbeck. Techn. Ge- meindebl., 1927-28, 30: 261; 278.—Saint Mary's Hospital of San Francisco completes new addition. West. Hosp. Rev., 1928, 11: 15-8.—Schmieden, H. Der Erweiterungsbau des Kreiskrankenhauses zu Crossen / Oder. Zschr. ges. Kranken- hauswes., 1926, 22: 193-8. ------ Ein Deutscher Vorent- wurf fur die Landes-Heil- und Pflegeanstalt El Tablon bei Sibat6, Republik Kolumbia, S. A. Ibid., 1927, 23: 259-63. ■----■— Die Erweiterung des Stadt- und Kreiskrankenhauses zu Quedlinburg. Ibid., 1928, 24: 154-6. ------ Dosquetsaal, Zwickauer Bausystem und Krankenhausgrundriss. Ibid., 270-2.—Schultze, L. White Plains; its present and future. Mod. Hosp., 1940, 54: No. 6, 64-7, illust.—Seneriz, R. H. External organization of the district hospitals. Puerto Rico Health Bull., 1940, 4: 344-8.—Setz, M. Die Um-, Zu- und Neubauten des Schwedischen V&xjo-Krankenhauses. Zschr. ges. Krankenhauswes., 1937, 226-9.—Sloan, R. P. Glens Falls grows by giving service. Mod. Hosp., 1941, 56: No. 2, 50-3, illust., plans.— Stephenson, A. G. A tramp abroad in the hospital held. Ibid., 1933, 41: 75-80.—Stevens, F. Hospital construction in the United States at the present time. Noso- komeion, Stuttg., 1931, 2: 1143-57.—Studio di progetto d'un centro ospedaliero e clinico-universitario a Praga pre quattro- mila letti. Osp. maggiore, Milano, 1938,26: 309-27.—Stuivinga, J., & Stuivinga, T. [The Bartholomew, Agnes and St Catherine Hospital in Utrecht] Ziekenhuis, 1928, 19: 63.—Sturm, M. J. Flexibility is keynote of new Augustana Hospital. Mod. Hosp., 1927, 28: 55-60.—Swanson, A. J., & Govan, J. The Toronto Western Hospital; a model in architectural arrangement. Hospitals, 1936, 10: No. 2, 44-52.—Taft (The) Hospital con- struction plan. J. Am. M. Ass., 1940, 114: 1670.—Taylor, R. C. Pueblo builds a hospital. Hvgeia, Chic, 1941, 19: 21-4, illust.—Tour (A) of Abbott Hospital. Mod. Hosp., 1941, 56: No. 6, 64-6, plans.—Van Os, S. Community hospital that features modern equipment and economical planning. Ibid., 1926, 27: 59-62.—Vestergren, E. Krankenpflege und Kranken- hausbauten in Schweden. Atti Congr. internaz. teen, san., 1931, 2. Congr., 2: 511-20. ------ L'Hopital Royal de l'Ordre des S6raphins de Stockholm et ses modernisations. Riv. internaz. ingegn. san., 1933, 1: 177-84.—Wakefield, C. E. New Flower Hospital building has many features of interest. Hosp. Management, 1926, 22: No. 4, 50-3.—Westerterp, M. [The New Colony Hospital at Beilen] Ziekenhuis, 1928, 19: 99-103.—Wyandotte General typical of newer type building. Hosp. Management, 1926, 22: 52; 59.—York, Sawyer & Zulauf, G. W. Pittsburgh's latest achievement in hospital planning. Mod. Hosp., 1931, 37: 61-9, pt 1. ---- Heating system. Fichtl. Wann ist der Anschluss eines Krankenhauses an ein Fernheizwerk wirtschaftlich? Zschr. ges. Krankenhauswes., 1938, 133-6.—Gehrenbeck, K. Technische Verbesserungen der Kesselanlage im Rudolf Virchow-Krankenhaus der Staat Berlin. Ibid., 1935, 25-9.—Held, E. F. M. van der. Das Flachdach als Warmeabdammung. Gesundh. Ingenieur, 1939, 62: 45.—Hottinger, M. Die Heiz-, Luftungs- und elektro- technischen Anlagen in der Krankenanstalt Glarus. Ibid., 1927, 50: 690; 857.—Lambert, C. F. New heating plant and laundry, St Mary's Hospital Kansas City, Missouri. Hosp. Progr., 1927, 8: 136-8.—Lehmann, R. Neues auf dem Gebiet der Heizung in Krankenhausern und ahnlichen Anstalten. Gesundh. Ingenieur, 1932, 55: 415.—Lommel, A. Das Heiz, und Kraft- werk der Wiirzburger Universitats-Kliniken. Ibid., 1936, 59: 425-9.—Maphis, O. B. Modern heating equipment cuts costs 40% at this hospital. Hosp. Management, 1935, 40: 29.— Neumann, O. Praktisch durchfuhrbare Versuche zur Ermitte- Iung der wirtschaftlichsten Rohrisolierung. Zschr. ges. Kran- kenhauswes., 1928, 24: 94-9.—Notes on heating systems for hospitals. In Hosp. Yearb., 1941, 19: 1023.—Piping change cuts hospital's fuel bill $2,300. Mod. Hosp., 1933, 40: 102.— Richter, H. Einfache Wege zur Kondensat-Ableitung. Zschr. ges. Krankenhauswes., 1929, 25: 71.—Seltzer, W. B. Proper insulation reduces fuel costs. Mod. Hosp., 1935, 44: 84.— Setz, M. Die Heizungsanlagen des Krankenhauses. Gesundh. Ingenieur, 1935, 58: 141-6. ------ Die Aufstellung der Heizkorper im Krankenhaus. Ibid., 1936, 59: 489-92. ------ Die Decken- und Fussbodenheizung im Krankenhaus. Ibid., 501-4. ---- Kitchen. Bacon, A. S., & Hunzicher, B. Gas equipment for cooking purposes. Tr. Am. Hosp. Ass., 1937( 39: 364-6.—Behrend. Ueber Speisetransport-Gefasse aus Kupfer im Wirtsrluifts- betriebe des Krankenhauses. Zschr. ges. Krankenhauswes., 1927, 23: 757.— Carlander, G. A. Kitchen planning in reverse Mod. Hosp., 1941, 56: No. 3, 90, ill- Frdman, A. Moderniza- tion of kitchens. In Hosp. Yearb., 1941, 19: 989-91.—Fergu- son, M. Kitchen equipment on parade. Mod. Hosp., 1941, 56: No. 4, 90.—Gillam, S. M. The commercial cafeteria at New University of Michigan Hospital. Hosp. Management, 1926, 21: No. 3, 27-30.—Hahn, W. Grosskhchenanlagen fur Krankenhausbetriebe. Zschr. ges. KrankerthauBwes., 1938, 6-10.-—Hohorst. Reinnickel als Baustoff fiir Grosskochan- lagen. Ibid., 1929, 25: 215.—Hunt, M. Good kitchen plan- ning. Mod. Hosp., 1938, 50: No. 3, 09-72.—Karadi. V. Wich- tigere Gesichtspunkte zur Plaining von Spitalgrosskilchen rationellen Betriebes. Zschr. ges. Krankenhauswes., 1939, 104-6.—Kitchen and food equipment at James Whitcomb Riley Hospital. Mod. Hosp., 1926, 26: 157.—Linke, F. Grosskuchenprobleme im Krankenhauswesen unter besonderer Beriicksichtigung der elektrischen Kiiche. Zschr. ges. Kran- kenhauswes., 1935, 485-8.—Riekemann, H. L'mstellung der Grosskuchen von Kohlen- auf Gasheizung. Ibid., 1927, 23: 415.—Steinweg, C. Die Wirtschaftlichkeit des elektrischen Kochens in der Grosskiiche. Ibid., 1930, 66.—Streamlined kitchen featured in modernization program. Hosp. Manage- ment, 1941, 52: No. 2, 21.—Troutt, L. M. Electrical equipment, for cooking purposes. Hospitals, 1937, 11: 98-100.—Weber, M. Factors to be considered in purchasing new equipment for the hospital kitchen. Hosp. Management, 1941, 52: 47.— Whitaker, R. The plan and equipment of kitchen offices in hospital and other institutions. Nosokomeion, Stuttg., 1937, 8: 229-35.—Wildman, R. The Swedish type stove. Tr. Am. Hosp. Ass., 1937, 39: 366-70. Also Hospitals, 1937, 11: No. 11, 101. ---- Landscaping. Bebb, G. C. Landscape by plan only. Mod. Hosp., 1941, 56: No. 2, 57-9.—Dunstan, E. M. Beauty treatment for county hospital grounds. Ibid., 1939, 531 No. 3, 73-5.— Penner, S. M. A garden at Greenpoint. Ibid., 1936, 46: No. 3, 68.—Phillips, R. A. Hospital landscaping and gardening. Hospitals, 1939, 13: No. 6, 75-83.—Sloan, R. P. Proper plant- ing for hospital grounds. Mod. Hosp., 1933, 41: 47-52.----- When the hospital goes in for gardening. -. Ibid., 1935, 44: 40-4.—Van Der Meer, W. J. St. Charles Hospital modern in design, equipment; happy use of back yard for flower beds, rock gardens, pool, shrines another unusual feature of new building at Aurora, 111. Hosp. Management, 1033, 35: 21-6.— Waldmann. Krankenhausgarten. Zschr. ges. Krankenhaus- wes., 1928, 24: 695. ---- Laundry system. Barkow, H. Moderne Waschcreianlagen in Kranken- hausern und Anstalten. Zschr. ges. Krankenhauswes., 1927, 23: 435-8.—Gehrenbeck, K. Erneuerung- der technischen Einrichtungen in der Wascherei des Rudolf Virchow-Kran- kenhauses. Ibid., 1939, 274-9.—Krecke, R. Neuzeitliche Betriebsumstellung in der Waschereianlage der Landesanstalt Gbrden. Ibid., 1934, 297-303.—Lommel, A. Der Wasche- abwurfschacht. Ibid., 1929, 25: 35.—Neumann, O. Die Wascherei im Krankenhause; Richtlinien fiir Beurteilung und Wahl der zweckmassigsten Maschinen. Ibid., 154. 461 — Opitz, H. Neuzeitliche Waschetrocknungsanlagen. Ibid., 1938, 213.—Poltavtsev, A. N. [Laundries for small cUnics, of 10-50 beds] Sovet. med., 1940, 4: No. 20, 36-41, plans- Savage, P. G. A unique hospital laundry installation. Hos- pitals, 1942, 16: No. 2, 75-7, plan. ---- Lighting. Alexander, H. W., Lee, F. B., & Ickis, L. S., jr. Lighting in the hospital. Tr. Ilium. Engin. Soc, 1938, 33: 523-44.— Amende, H., & Oetker, E. Zur naturlichen Beleuchtung von Krankenraumen. Zschr. ges. Krankenhauswes., 1935, SSL- Automatic corridor lighting. Mod. Hosp., 1938, 50: No. 4, 69.—Barreto, J. de B. Illuminacao moderna nos hospitaes. In Conf. sem. hosp. (Assist. Hosp. Brasil) Rio de Jan., 1929, 91-10o.—Bazin, A. T. It's the wound not the room that needs can-ful lighting. Mod. Hosp., 1934, 42: 75-^.9.—Crews, J. M. No blackouts for hospitals. Ibid., 1941, 56: No. 3, 88.—Distel, H. Besonnung von Krankenhausern. Zschr. ges. Kranken- hauswes., 1933, 111-5.—Emergency lighting and power for hospitals. Brit. M. J., 1941, 1: 634.—Fleming, H. T. Shadow- less lamp with universal range. Ibid., 1940, 2: 322.—Groher, H. Beleuchtungsfragen im Krankenhaus. Zschr. ges. Kran- kenhauswes., 1939, 25-7.—Harland, P. J. B. Hospital lighting. J. R. Nav. M. Serv., 1936, 22: 128-31.—Hitzler, W. Das kunstliche Licht im Krankenhaus. Zschr. ges. Krankenhaus- wes., 1938, 28-32. ------ Die Notbeleuchtung in Kranken- hausern. Ibid., 197-201.—Lethly, M. W. A hospital designed to ensure its patients light and air. Mod. Hosp., 1933, 40: 65-72.—Mehl, H. Intensitiitsmessung der natUrlichen Beleuchtung von Krankenraumen. Zschr. ges. Kranken- hauswes., 1937- 3-11.—Neergaard, C. F. Emergency lighting HOSPITAL CONSTRUCTION 829 HOSPITAL CONSTRUCTION in hospitals. Bull. Am. Coll. Surgeons, 1939, 24: 190 — Nicholson, C. Lighting of wards. Lancet, Lond., 1941, 2: 471.—Planning for light when current fails! Surg. Equip., 1942, 9: 16.—Sentichal, M. Dispositif d'6clairage nocturne des salles d'operation par les tubes a gaz rares. P. verb. Congr. fr. chir., 1933, 42. Congr., 1067-71.—Tierney, J. W. Light insurance for hospitals. Hospitals, 1938, 12: No. 8, 49-52.— Unruh, W. Die Sicherstellung der Beleuchtung von grossen Anstalten als Panik- und Luftschutzsicherung. Zschr. ges. Krankenhauswes., 1939, 262.—Walsh, W. H. Hospital light- ing. Hospitals, 1936, 10: No. 2, 59-69. Also repr. ------ Lighting in the modern hospital. In Hosp. Yearb., 1941, 19: 984-8. --- Noise control. Agnew, G. H. Noise in the hospital. Hospitals, 1938, 12: No. 12, 39.----— Noise in the hospital; its effect on patients; its control. Bull. Am. Coll. Surgeons, 1939, 24: 189.—Bergman, S. M. Rubber aids quiet, decoration, low maintenance cost. Hosp. Management, 1934, 37: 28-30.—Clough, H. D. A new- deal in sound. Hospitals, 1938, 12: No. 12, 90.—Doorentz, R. Schallschutz im Krankenhausbau. Zschr. ges. Kranken- hauswes., 1937, 97-103.—Govan, J., Anderson, G. R., & Reilley, H. E. Twin problems in construction; insulation and acoustics. Mod. Hosp., 1934, 42: 52-6.—Hodge, W. J. Hos- pital noise. Tr. Am. Hosp. Ass., 1938, 40: 682-7.—Linke, F. Gerausch- und Erschiitterungsisolierung im Krankenhausbau. Zschr. ges. Krankenhauswes., 1931, 409-13. ------ Ein neuer wirksamer Erschiitterungsschutz fiir Krankenhaus- bauten. Ibid., 1933, 277.—Lommel. Hellhorigkeit und Schalldampfung in Krankenhausern. Ibid., 1927, 23: 36-40.— Martin, S. T. How Regina General Hospital has reduced noise. Hosp. Management, 1934, 37: 31.—Momberger, W. J. Check on door checks. Mod. Hosp., 1940, 54: No. 5, 96.—Morrill, W. P. Control of noise and nuisances. Hospitals, 1939, 13: No. 6, 57-9.—Neergaard, C. F. What it costs to make a hos- pital quiet. Mod. Hosp., 1929, 32: No. 4, 71-6 What can the hospital do about noise? Hospitals, 1941, 15: No. 12, 42—4.—Norenberg. Larmbekampfung im Kranken- hause. Zschr. ges. Krankenhauswes., 1939, 281-3.—Oehl- schlager, J. Erschiitterungs- und Schalldampfung. Ibid., 1928, 24: 406.—Quiet in the hospital. Northwest M., 1940, 39: 200.—Rosenzweig, S. Eliminating vibration and noise in hospitals. Hosp. Management, 1936, 41: 30-3.—Schulzke, W., & Brooks,' M. N. Build for quiet and comfort. Mod. Hosp., 1937, 49: No. 5, 52-7.—Staely, F. B. Practical sugges- tions for reducing noises within the hospital. Hosp. Manage- ment, 1941, 52: No. 2, 49.—Von Sternberg, J. R. Noise elimination in hospitals. Ibid., 1937, 44: No. 2, 22; 26.— Watson, F. R. Making the hospital quiet. Mod. Hosp., 1926, 26: 245-8.—ZUI. Schalldampfende Konstruktion einer Krankenzimmertiir. Gesundh. Ingenieur, 1929, 52: 91. --- Planning. Hammond, G. F. A treatise on hospital and asylum construction; with special reference to pavilion wards. 172p. 8? Cleveland, Ohio, 1891. Nelson, P. Deux etudes: Maison de sant6 et pavilion de chirurgie. [16]p. 28 pl. 24cm. Par. [1936] York & Sawyer (New York) Specifications for a hospital erected at West Chester, Pennsyl- vania, for Chester County. 488p. 4? N. Y., 1927. A, C. B. The changing architecture of London hospitals. Nurs. Times, Lond., 1938, 34: 1086-8.—Albl, H. Neue Wege im Krankenhausbau. Schweiz. med. Wschr., 1932, 62: 1140- 2.—Alter. A questionnaire on hospital architecture. Noso- komeion, Stuttg., 1936, 7: 7-12. ------ Baufragen im Krankenhauswesen. Gesundh. Ingenieur, 1927, 50: 629-40.— Baumgarten, A. Ueber die Wichtigkeit arztlicher Fachgutach- ten bei Errichtung von Heilanstalten. Wien. med. Wschr., 1930, 80: 1657-9.—Bordoni, A. II nuovo tipo di infermeria Bordoni. Osp. maggiore, Milano, 1937, 29: 457-9.—Bos, A. C. [Planning of a colony hospital] Ziekenhuis, 1928, 19: 23-5.— Bowen, L. R. Planning for state hospitals. Mod. Hosp., 1939, 52: No. 2, 61-5.—Canalis, P. Nuovi orizzonti nella costruzione degli ospedali. Igiene mod., 1929, 22: 323-43. Also Italia san., 1929, 21: No. 20, 3; No. 21, 3.—Cederstrom, H. Vorschlag zu einem vereinfachten System fur den Austausch von Zeichnungen und beschreibenden Angaben betreffend Krankenhausplanung. Zschr. ges. Krankenhauswes., 1937, 30-3.—Celotti, A. Tipo costruttivo e costituenti funzionali di un moderno ospedale di 800 posti-letto. Osp. maggiore, Milano, 1940, 28: 49-60.—Chappotin y Diaz, M., & Muniz Angulo, L. Hospitales rodantes. Rev. san. mil., Habana, 1938, 2: 298-307.—Creel, R. H. A seaman's hospital; build at low cost, compact in design. Mod. Hosp., 1935, 45: No. 2, 42-7.—Crodel, W. Ueber Krankenhaus-Pavillons in Holz- bauweise. Zschr. ges. Krankenhauswes., 1930, 704-6.— Distel, H. Neuere europaische Gross-Krankenhausprojekte. Ibid., 1935 341-6.—Dix. Umbau und Erweiterung alterer Krankenpavillons nach neuzeithchen Grundsatzen (Dosquet) K" l926' 2£J^TD°ane- LC'„Aaepsis and architecture. Mod. Hosp 1938, 51: No. 5, 69.—Docker, R. Das Kranken- haus Waibhngen und das Buch Terrassentyp. Zschr 1889/9°; ^ '891/92: Baltimore, Md. Maryland General Hos- pital. Annual report [Bait.] 1910; 1919/20- 1921/22; 1930/31-1933/34; 1938/39- Report for 1910 reads: Maryland General Hospital and The Maryland Lying-in Hospital. Baltimore, Md. Mercy Hospital. Annual report. Bait., 1910-17; 1919-22; 1924-25. Baltimore, Md. St Agnes' Hospital. Annual report. Bait., 1910; 1911; 1915. Baltimore, Md. St Joseph's Hospital. Report (annual and biennial) Bait., 1.-5 , 1871-75; 1892/95; 1904; 1907-22; 1925-26. Reports for 1907-16 read:-St Joseph's German Hospital. --- Bangor, Maine. Bangor, Me. Eastern Maine General Hospital. Annual reports. Bangor, 4.-42.. 1894/95-1933/34. --- Barbados. Barbados General Hospital. Report [Bridgetown] 1931/32. --- Bayonne, New Jersey. Bayonne Hospital and Dispensary. An- nual report. N. Y., 1.-5., 1890/91-1894/95; 14., 1903/4. ---- Bengal, India. Bengal, India. Inspector-General of Civil Hospitals. Report (annual and triennial) of the charitable dispensaries under the govern- ment of Bengal, and the Calcutta medical institu- tions. Calc, 1902-10. Bengal, India. Surgeon-General with the Government of Bengal. Report (annual and triennial) on the working of the hospitals and dispensaries. Alipore, 1911- ---- Bergen, Norway. Bergen, Norway. Kommunale Sykehuse. Aarsberetning. Bergen, 1921/22-1922/23; 1928/ 29-1932/33; 1934/35; 1936/37- ---- Berlin, Germany. Jacob, P. Jahresbericht iiber die Poliklinik der I. medici- nischen Universitatsklinik. Charit6-Ann., Berl., 1903, 27: 40-5;1904, 28: 3-7.—Miiller, O. Verwaltungs-Nachrichten iiber das Konigliche Charite-Krankenhaus. Ibid., 1903, 27: --- Bermuda. Bermuda. King Edward the Seventh Memorial Hospital. Report [Hamilton] 1927- 35; 1938- --- Bethlehem, Pennsylvania. Bethlehem, Pa. Saint Luke's Hospital. Annual report. Bethlehem, 1.-42., 1873/74- 1914/15; 44.-46., 1916/17-1918/19; 48.-49., 1920/21-1921/22; 62.-66., 1935/36- ---- Beverly, Massachusetts. Beverly Hospital. Annual report. Beverly, 1.-6., 1893/94-1898/99; 8., 1900/1; 12., 1904/5; 15., 1907/8. ---- Big Rapids, Michigan. Big Rapids,- Mich. Mercy Hospital [An- nual] report [Big Rapids] (1906) 1907- HOSPITAL REPORT 836 HOSPITAL REPORT ---- Bihar, India. Bihar. India. Inspector-General of Civil Hospitals. Report (annual and triennial) of hospitals and dispensaries. Patna, 1936- For earlier numbers, see: Bihar and Orissa. Inspector- general of civil hospitals. ---- Bihar and Orissa, India. Bihar and Orissa, India. Inspector-Gen- eral of Civil Hospitals. Report (annual and triennial) of hospitals and dispensaries. Patna, 1911-35. For later reports, sec: Orissa, India. Director of health and inspector-general of prisons. See also Bihar, India. Inspector-general of civil hospitals. ---- Bismarck, North Dakota. Bismarck, X. Dak. St Alexius Hospital. Reports. Bismarck, 1916/17 1917/18; 1920/21. ---- Bombay Province, India. Bombay Province, India. Surgeon Gen- eral. Report (annual and triennial) on the Civil Hospitals and Dispensaries. Bombay, 1 SS9- Reports for 1891-1900 read: Mofnssil Civil Hospitals and Dispensaries. ---- Boston, Massachusetts. Boston, Mass. Boston City Hospital. Annual report. Bost., 1., 1864- ---- Medical and surgical reports. Bost., Ser. 1. 7., 1870 96; Ser. 9.-10., 1898-99; Ser. 12., 1901; Ser. 14., 1903. Boston, Mass. Boston Dispensary. Annual report. Bost., 62., 1X5S/59- Boston, Mass. Boston Floating Hospital. Annual report. Bost., 1.-14., 1894/95-1907. Boston, Mass. Boston Home for Incur- ables. Annual report. Bost., 1.-5., 18X5/86 1889/90; 16., 1901/2; 21., 1906/7; 23., 1908/10- Bostox, Mass. Boston Infirmary Depart- ment. Annual report. Bost., 12.-26., 1908/9- 1922/23. For earlier reports, see: Boston, Mass. Pauper Institutions Department. Boston, Mass. Carney Hospital. Annual report. Bost., 36.-43., 1879-86; 47.-72., 1890- 1915; 95., 1938. Boston, Mass. Channing Home. Report. Bost., 1., 1 SOS/09; 4.-39., 1871/72-1900/7; 42.-44. 1910-12; 51.. 192S- Boston, Mass. Emerson Hospital. Medi- cal, surgical and obstetrical report. Bost., 1907- 11; 1923. Boston, Mass. Faulkner Hospital. An- nual report. Jamaica Plain, 1.-5., 1903/4- 1907/X; 10., 1913/14. Boston, Mass. House of the Good Samari- tan. Annual report. Bost., 1.-44., 1861-1904; 66.. 1926; 73., 1933. Boston, Mass. Joseph II. Pratt Diagnostic Hospital. Information for physicians and patients. 8p. 15'jcm. Bost., 1940. Bostox, Mass. McLean Hospital. Annual report. YYaverly, Mass., 10., 1823- Bostox, Mass. Massachusetts Gexeral Hospital. Annual report. Bost., 1823; 1827-29; 1832-33; 1835-1918; 118.-119., 1931-32; 122., 1935- Bostox, Mass. Massachusetts Home for Intemperate Women. Report. Bost., 1.-23 INS 1/82-1903/4. Boston, Mass. New England Baptist Hospital. Annual report. Bost., 4.-12., 1897- 1905. Boston, Mass. Xew England Hospital for Women and Children. Annunl report. Bost. 1.-02 , 1S02 0H 1922 23; 04. 66., I92.V26 1927 "2S OS., 1920 30; 70.-71., 193132 1932/33; 73.-77., 1934/35 Boston, Mass. Pauper Institutions De- partment. Annual report. Bost., I. -11., 1897/98-1907/8. Continued by: Boston, Mass. Boston Infirmary Depart- ment. Boston, Mass. Peter Bent Brigham Hospital. Annual report [Bost.] 1.-24., 1913-37. Boston, Mass. Vincent Memorial Hospi- tal. Annual report. Bost., 1.-9., 1891/92 1X99 1900; 11.-15., 1901/2-1905/6. ---- Bourton-on-the-Water, England. Bourton-on-the-Water, England. Cottage Hospital. Annual report. Stow-on-the-Wold, 1883; 1SS7- 1900; 1903-16; 1918. ---- Bridgeport, Connecticut. Bridgeport, Conn. Bridgeport Hospital. Annual report. Bridgeport, 1.-3., 1879/80- 1881/82; 5.-26., 1SX3/S4 -1904/5; 28., 1906/7; 30., 1908/9; 33.-36., 1911/12-1914/15; 39., 1917/18. Bridgeport, Conn. St Vincent's Hospital. Report (annual and biennial) Bridgeport, 1.-4., 1905-12; 17., 1921/22. ---- Brockenhurst, England. Perry, E. F. Report of the Lady Ilardinge Hospital, Brockenhurst, Hants, England, from 20th January to 15th June, 1915. Ind. M. Gaz., 1915, 50: .'101. ---- Brockton, Massachusetts. Brockton, Mass. Brockton Hospital. Annual report, Brockton, 2.-7., 1899-1904; 9., 1906; 11., 1908- ■--- Brooklyn, New York. Brooklyn, N. V. Brooklyn Hospital. Report. Brooklyn, 2., 1848-49; 1852; 1856; 1858; 1805; 1867-68; 1870; 1872; 1874; 1877; 1884; 1890; 1892; 1894-98; 1900; 1902; 1904-8; 1910-11;1913-20. Brooklyn, X. Y. Long Island College Hospital. Annual announcement. Brooklyn, 1.-15., 1860-1873/74; 20.-37., 1876/77-1895/96; 39.-40.. 1897/98-1898/99; 42.-45., 1900/1-1903/4; 49., 1900/7; 59., 1917/18. Brooklyn, X. Y. Methodist Episcopal Hospital. Annual report, Brooklyn, 1., 1888- Brooklyn, N. Y. St Catharine's Hospital. Annual reports. Brooklyn, 7.-9., 1877-79; 16.-29., 1886-99; 32., 1902. Brooklyn, N. Y. St Mary's Hospital. Annual report. Brooklyn, 1., 1883; 2., 1884-88; 1901-4; 1906; 1908; 1913-20. Brooklyn, X. Y. St Peter's Hospital. Annual report. Brooklyn, 12. 13., 1878-79; 15., 1881; 21., 1887; 23.-32., 1889-98; 34.-51., 1900-17. Brooklyn, X. Y. Samaritan- Wyckoff Heights Hospital. Report [Brooklyn] 1938- ---- Buffalo, New York. Buffalo General Hospital. Annual report. Buffalo, 18(16-67; 1873; 1X75; 1881; 26. 49., 1884-1906/7; 06., 1923/24; 69. 76., 1926/27-34; 78., 1936- HOSPITAL REPORT 837 HOSPITAL REPORT ---- Burma, India. Burma, India. Inspector-General of Civil Hospitals. Report (annual and triennial) on hospitals and dispensaries. Rangoon, 1899-1930; 1932- Burma. Ministry of report on the hospitals Burma for the year 1933. Education. Annual and dispensaries in Rangoon, 1934. ---- Buxton, England. Buxton, England. Devonshire Royal Hospital and Buxton Bath Charity. Annual report. Buxton, 1908-11; 1913-15; 1918-24; 1926/27- Prior to 1932/33, reads: Devonshire Hospital and Buxton Bath Charity. --- Cairo, Egypt. Cairo, Egypt. Hopital Victoria des Diaconesses. Rapport du comite. Le Caire, 1914. ---- Calcutta, India. Lukis, C. P. The report of the Medical College Hospital, Calcutta. Ind. M. Gaz., 1907, 42: 206-15, pl. --- Cambridge, Massachusetts. Cambridge Hospital. Report of the trustees. Cambridge, 1., 1867-68; 1870-71; 1887/88- 1889/90; 1892/93; 1901-3; 1905; 1907-9. --- Camden, New Jersey. Camden, X. J. Camden City Dispensary. Annual report of the Board of Managers. Cam- den, 27.-39., 1893/94-1905/6; 41., 1907/8. Camden, N. J. Cooper Hospital. Annual report, Camden, 1887-94; 1896-1908; 1910-12; 1914-22; 1938- --- Canada. First (The) annual report of hospitals in Canada for the year 1932. Canad. M. Ass. J., 1935, 32: 555. --- Canton, China. Canton, China. Sun Yat Sen Memorial Canton Hospital. Annual report. Canton, 1858-69; 1870-81; 1881-99; 1902-3; 1905; 1907; 1909-11; 1913-23; 1930-35; 1939-40. Reports for 1858-99 read: Reports of the Medical Mis- sionary Society in China. --- Cape of Good Hope (Province) South Africa. Cape of Good Hope (Province), South Africa. Provincial Medical Adviser. Re- port ... on the government and state-aided hospi- tals and kindred charitable institutions of the Province. Cape Town, 1910-11. --- Catanzaro, Italy. Catanzaro, Italy. Manicomio Provinciale. Annali. Pal., v.7, Xo. 1, 1920. --- Cedar Rapids, Iowa. Cedar Rapids, Iowa. St Luke's Hospital. Annual report. Cedar Rapids, 1892/93; 1895/96- 1898/99; 1907/8. --- Ceylon. Ceylon. Department of Medical and Sanitary Services. Administrative report of the director. Colombo, 1898- Contains data on hospitals; published annually; prior to 1925 the title reads: Report of the principal civil medical officer and inspector-general of hospitals. Ceylon. Office of the Principal Civil Medical Officer and Inspector-General of Hospitals. Hospital returns. Colombo, 1901- Published annually. See also Ceylon. Depaitment of Medical and Sanitary Services. 1898. J ---- Charlotte, North Carolina. Charlotte, X. C. Duke Endowment Hospital Section. Annual report. Charlotte 1., 1925— Charlotte, N. C. St Peter's Hospital Annual reports. Charlotte, 1876-77; 1881-95- 22.-32., 1897-1907; 34., 1909. Prior to 1898 reads: Report of the Home and Hospital"of St Peter s Church. ---- Chefoo, China. Chefoo, China. Temple Hill Hospital Report. Chefoo, 1920-34. ---- Chicago, Illinois. Chicago, III. Augustana Hospital. Re- port. Chic., 1896/97-1906. Chicago, III. Central Free Dispensary of West Chicago. Report. Chic, 4.-17., 1870/71- 1883/84; 22.-35., 1887/88-1900/1; 37., 1903-6. Chicago, III. Cook County Hospital. Annual report, Chic, 1915-20; 1922-26. Chicago, III. Mercy Hospital. Annual report [Chic] 1894/95-1898/99; 1900/1; 1902; 1904; 1906. Chicago, III. Presbyterian Hospital. Annual report. Chic, 5.-14., 1887/88-1896/97; 16.-18., 1898/99-1900/1; 20.-25.. 1902/3-1907/8. Chicago, III. Protestant Memorial Hos- pital. Annual report of the superintendent to the trustees for the year 1904. Milwaukee, 1905. Chicago, III. Provident Hospital and Training School. Annual report. Chic, 1., 1891/92; 3., 1893/94; 5.-9., 1895/96-1899/1900; 16., 1906/7; 1908/9; 21.-22., 1911/12-1912/13; 24., 1914/15; 27.-28., 1917/18-1918/19; 31., 1921/22. Chicago, III. St Elizabeth Hospital. Annual report, Chic, 25.-26., 1912-13; 28.-39., 1915-26. Chicago, III. St Luke's Hospital. Annual report, Chic. 24., 1886/87; 27.-37., 1889/90- 1899/1900; 39.-43., 1901/2-1905/6; 45.-46., 1907/8-1908/9. Chicago, III. Washington Home. Annual report. Chic, 8., 1871; 10.-11., 1873-74; 13., 1876; 15.-17., 1878-80; 19.-36., 1882-99; 38.. 1901. Chicago, III. W'esley Memorial Hospital. Annual reports. Chic, 2.-3., 1888/89-1890/91; 7.-10., 1894/95-1897/98; 14.-18., 1900/1-1906/7; 20.-21., 1908/9-1909/10; 23.-29., 1911-17; 33.- 35., 1921-23; 37.-38., 1925-26; 42.-43., 1928-31; 45.-50., 1933-38. ---- Chung King, China. Assmy. Berichte uber den Betrieb der Poliklinik Chungking vom 1. Juli 1908 bis 30. Juni 1910. Klin. Jahrb., 1911, 25: 72-120. ---- Cincinnati, Ohio. Cincinnati, Ohio. Christ Hospital. An- nual report. Cincin., 49., 1938- Cincinnati, Ohio. Cincinnati General Hospital. Annual report. Cincin., 1868-99; 1901-11; 1914; 1938-39. Reports for 1808-1911 read: Cincinnati Hospital; prior to 1868, was: Cincinnati Commercial Hospital. HOSPITAL REPORT 83. ■8 HOSPITAL REPORT Cincinnati, Ohio. Protestant Episcopal Church Hospital. Annual report, Cincin., 1.-20., 1883/84-1902/3. Cincinnati, Ohio. St Francis Hospital for Incurables. Annual report. Cincin., 22.-30., 1910-18; 32., 1920. Cincinnati, Ohio. St Mary's Hospital. Annual report. Cincin., 1881-1914. --- Cleveland, Ohio. Cleveland, Ohio. Cleveland Charity Hospital. Biennial report. Cleveland, 1888-89. Cleveland, Ohio. Cleveland City Hos- pital. Annual report. Clevel., 1876; 1880; 1913; 1915; 1938; 1939. Cleveland, Ohio. Cleveland General Hospital. Annual report. Cleveland, 1895/6. Cleveland, Ohio. Lakeside Hospital. An- nual report. Clevel., 22.-27., 1888-93; 29., 1895; 32.-45., 1898-1911; 47., 1913; 50.-57., 1916-23; 59., 1925. ---- Columbia, Pennsylvania. Columbia Hospital. Annual report of the board of directors and officers to the contributors. Columbia, 9., 1903-4. ---- Columbus, Ohio. Columbus, Ohio. St. Anthony's Hospital. Annual report. Columb., 6.-20., 1897-1911; 24.-25., 1915-16. Columbus, Ohio. St. Francis Hospital. Annual report. Columbus, 28., 1894; 30.-35., 1895-1900; 37.-51., 1902-16. ---- Concord, New Hampshire. Concord, N. H. Margaret Pillsbury General Hospital. Annual reports. Concord, 8.-23., 1891-1906. --- Cooperstown, New York. Cooperstown, N. Y. Mary Imogene Bas- sett Hospital. Annual report. Cooperstown, 1.-2., 1922/23-1923/24. --- Copparo, Italy. Copparo, Italy. Ospedale S. Giuseppe in Copparo. Resoconto clinico statistico per l'anno 1901-2. Bologna [1902] --- Covington, Kentucky. Covington, Ky. St Elizabeth's Hospital. Annual report. Covington, 1., 1902. --- Danbury, Connecticut. Danbury, Conn. Danbury Hospital. An- nual report. Danbury, 1.-15., 1885-1899/1900. --- Danville, Pennsylvania. Danville, Pa. George F. Geisinger Memo- rial Hospital. Annual report. Danville 1., 1915/16; 3., 1917/18-1919/20; 4., 1920/21. Report for 1920-21, on single sheet, is a condensed report. ---- Dartford, England. Dartford, Engl. Livingstone Hospital for Dartford and District. Annual report Dartford, 1895-1917. Prior to 1911, title reads: Livingstone Cottage Hospital for Dartford and District. ---- Dayton, Ohio. Dayton, Ohio. Miami Valley Hospital Society. Annual report. Dayton, 18.-19 1907-8; 22., 1911. Dayton, Ohio. St Elizabeth Hospital. Annual report. Dayton, 1.-3., 1878/79-1880/81- 6.-32., 1884-1910; 35.-36., 1913-14. ---- Dearborn, Michigan. Dearborn, Mich. Saint Joseph's Retreat. Annual reports of the attending physicians to the sisters in charge. Detroit, 11., 1892; 13.-20., 1894-1901; 22., 1903. ---- Denver, Colorado. Denver, Colo. St Anthony's Hospital. Annual report. Denver, 1903; 1906-9. ---- Derby, England. Derby, Engl. Derbyshire Royal In- firmary. Annual report. Derby, 1868/69- 1883/84; 1890/91-1903/4; 1906/7-1921/22; 1923/24-1924/25; 1926/27-1927/28. Prior to 1884, title was: Derbyshire General Infirmary. ---- Detroit, Michigan. Detroit, Mich. Grace Hospital. Annual report. Detr., 1.-10., 1889-98; 14.-25., 1902- 13; 37.-38., 1925-26; 40.-43., 1928-31; 49., 1937. Detroit, Mich. Harper Hospital. Annual report. Detr., 48., 1911. ---- Douglas, Isle of Man. Douglas, Isle of Man. Noble's Isle of Man Hospital and Dispensary. Annual report. Douglas, 1914-27. ---- Dover, New Hampshire. Dover, N. H. Wentworth Hospital. An- nual report. [Dover] 1906-12; 1914-24; 1939. --- Dublin, Ireland. Dublin, Ireland. Board of Superinten- dence of Dublin Hospitals. Annual report. Dubl., 1., 1856/57; 185X/59-1860/61; 1864/65- 1875/76; 1879/80-1896/97; 1916/17; 1918/19. Dublin, Ireland. Royal City of Dublin Hospital. Annual report of the directors to the governors and subscribers. Dubl., 74.-76. (1905-7) 1906-8. ---- Dunwich, Queensland. Dunwich, Queensland. Dunwich Benevo- lent Asylum. Annual report. Brisb., 1917-18; 1921. --- Eastbourne, England. Eastbourne, England. Princess Alice Memorial Hospital. Annual report. East- bourne, 1883-99; 1905-21. --- Easton, Pennsylvania. Easton, Pa. Easton Hospital. Annual report. Easton, 1.-8., 1890/91-1897/98; 20., 1910; 22., 1912; 25., 1915; 27.-29., 1916/17- 1918/19; 31., 1920/21; 33., 1922/23- ---- Edinburgh, Scotland. Edinburgh, Scotland. Royal Infirmary. Annual report [Edinb.] 1X67/68-1874/75; 1879/80; 1884; 1884/85-1919/20; 1927/28-1931/32; 1933/34-1935/36. HOSPITAL REPORT 839 HOSPITAL REPORT --- Egypt. Egypt. Department of Public Health. Kasr el Aini Hospital. Annual report. Cairo, 1928. --- Elizabeth, New Jersey. Elizabeth, N. J. Elizabeth General Hos- pital and Dispensary. Annual report [Eliza- beth] 4.-9., 1882-88; 12.-21., 1891-1900; 23.-30., 1902-9; 40.-42., 1919-21. ---- Elmira, New York. Elmira, N. Y. Arnot-Ogden Memorial Hospital. Annual report. Elmira, 1.-22., 1889-1910; 25.-26., 1913-14. --- Fall River, Massachusetts. Fall River, Mass. Highland Hospital. Annual report. Fall River., 4.-6., 1912/13- 1914/15. Fall River, Mass. Truesdale Hospital. Annual report. Fall River, 7.-11., 1915/16- 1920; 29., 1938- --- Fiji. Fiji. Medical Department. Annual medical report. [Suva] 1898-1930. Prior to 1908, title reads: Annual statistical return of the Colonial Hospital, the Provincial Hospitals, and Lunatic Asylum. --- Foochow, China. Foochow, China. Foochow Missionary Hospital. Annual report. [Foochow] 1., 1871/72-82/83; 1884-85; 1886/87; 1887-89; 1909- 12; 1914; 1916-22; 1924-25. --- Fountain Spring, Pennsylvania. Fountain Spring, Pa. State Hospital for Injured Persons of the Anthracite Coal Region of Pennsylvania. Official reports. Fountain Spring, 4.-35., 1886/87-1917/18. --- Frederick, Maryland. Frederick, Md. Frederick City Hospital. Annual report. Frederick, 1.-2., 1897/98- 1898/99; 19., 1916/17. --- Fredriksvern, Norway. Sundt. H. [Report from the seashore hospital at Fredriks- vern] Med. rev., Bergen, 1920, 37: 5-30. --- Freiburg i. B., Germany. Freiburg, Germany. Freiburger Diakonis- senhaus. Jahresbericht [Freib. i. B.] 1927-31. --- Genova, Italy. Parodi, F. Ospedali civili di Genova; rendiconto clinico statistico. Pammatone, Genova, 1901. 8: p. iii-xii; 1-73. --- Goteborg, Sweden. Goteborg, Sweden. Sjukhusdirektion. Arsberattelse. Goteborg, 1933-39. --- Grand Rapids, Michigan. Grand Rapids, Mich. Butterworth Hos- pital. Annual report. Grand Rapids, 1902/3. --- Habana, Cuba. Habana. ClInica de la Asociaci6n de Damas de- La Covadonga. Boletin mensual. Habana, v.l, No. 6, 1934- ---■ Hagevik, Norway. Hagevik, Norway. Kysthospitalet. Aars- beretning. Bergen, 1920/21. --- Halifax, Canada. Halifax, Canada. Nova Scotia Hospital. Annual reports of the medical superintendent to the commissioner of public works and mines. Halifax, 1.-46. (1858-1902/3) 1859-1904; 74., Halifax, Canada. Victoria General Hos- pital. Annual report. Halifax, 27.-33., 1893- 1898/99; 54., 1919/20; 61., 1926/27; 64.-70., 1929/30-1935/36. ---- Hamburg, Germany. Hamburg, Germany. Krankenhauskolle- gium. Jahresbericht [Hamburg] 1910-14. --- Hanoi", Indo-China. Chouquet. Statistique de la policlinique des indigenes de Hanoi: annee 1911. Bull. Soc. mid. chir. Indo-Chine, 1912, 3: 655-61. ------ Statistique de la policlinique des indigenes de Hanoi. Ibid., 1913, 4: 260-71.—Le Roy des Barres. A. Fonctionnement de l'hopital indigene du Protectorat pendant 1'annee 1911. Ibid., 1912, 3: 471-501. ------ Fonctionne- ment de l'hopital indigene du Protectorat k Hanoi pendant 1'annee 1912. Ibid., 1913, 4: 185-230. --- Hanover, New Hampshire. Hanover, N. H. Mary Hitchcock Memo- rial Hospital. Annual report. Hanover. 1.-9., 1893/94-1901/2. ---- Hansford, West Virginia. Hansford, W. Va. Sheltering Arms Hos- pital. Annual report. Hansford, 1897/98- 1898/99; 12., 1900/1; 19.-22., 1907/8-1910/11: 25., 1913/14. ---- Hartford, Connecticut. Hartford, Conn. Hartford Hospital. An- nual report. Hartford, 1., 1855/56- ---- Haverhill, Massachusetts. Haverhill, Mass. Hale Hospital. Report. Haverhill, 12.-13., 1899-1900; 15., 1902. ---- Hawaii, U. S. A. Hawaii, U. S. A. Board of Hospitals and Settlement. Report [Honolulu] 1937/38- ---- Hazleton, Pennsylvania. Hazleton, Pa. State Hospital for Injured Persons of the Middle Coal Fidle District. Biennial reports of the trustees and officers to the Board of Public Charities of Pennsylvania. Hazleton (1894/95-1901/2) 1896-1902. ---- Condensed report of trustees and super- intendent. Hazleton, 1914/16-1918/20. ---- HelsingoT, Denmark. Helsing0r, Denmark. Kuranstalt Monte- bello. Aarsberetning. Helsing0r, 1920; 1922; 1924. --- Helsinki, Finland. Helsinki, Finland. Marie Sjukhus. Ars- berattelse. Helsin., 1895-1906. Rosqvist, I. Medicinska afdelningen; redogorelse. Arsber. Maria Sjukhus i Helsingfors (1905) 1906, 11: 25-45. Hoboken, New Jersey. Hoboken, N. J. St Mary's Hospital. Annual report. Hoboken, 1871-75; 1888-93; 1895; 1897-1913. ---- Holsterhausen, Germany. Kohler, F. XL Jahresbericht der Heilstatte Holsterhausen bei Werden (Ruhr) fur 1912. Zbl. allg. Gesundhpfl., 1913, 32: 183-201. HOSPITAL REPORT 840 HOSPITAL REPORT ---- Holyoke, Massachusetts. Holyoke, Mass. Holyoke City Hospital. Annual report. Holvoke, 2. 5., 1S95-98; 20., 1910; 22., 1912; 24.-25.. 1914-15; 27.-31., 1917-21; 47.-4S.. 1937 3X. -- Forty-four years of life saving; a book of pictures, questions and answers about vour Holyoke Hospital. 23p. 12? [Holyoke] 1935. ---- Hong Kong, China. Hong Kong, China. Than Yuk Hospital. Clinical report IHong Kong] 1932/33-1934/35. ---- Honolulu, Hawaii. Honolulu, Hawaii. Leahi Home. Annual report. Honolulu. 1914; 1916; 1918-19; 1921; 1923; 1925-30. ---- Horncastle, England. HORNCASTLE, ENGLAND. HoHN'CASTLE PUBLIC Dispensary. Annual report. Horncastle, 1X79/80-1885/N6; 1891'92-1893/94; 1895-1909; 1911-18. ---- Hue, Indo-China. Renault. Fonctionnement du premier service de l'hopital de Hu6 pendant l'ann£e 1911. Ann. hyg. mid. colon., 1913, 16: 400-36. ---- Hyderabad, India. Hyderabad, India. Inspector-General of Dispensaries. Annual report and note on the annual return of the civil hospitals and charitable dispensaries of the Hyderabad As- signed Districts and Civil Hospital, Secnndern.bad. Hyderabad, 1X74-91; 1893; 1X94; 1897; 1899; 1990; 1902. ---- India. India. Central India Agency. Adminis- trative Medical Officer. Annual report on the working of Ihe hospitals, dispensaries, jail hospitals, and the registration of vital statis- tics ... and on vaccination. Calc, 1912-1923/24. India. Central Provinces and Berar. Medical Department. Report, (annual and biennial) on Civil Hospitals and Dispensaries. Xagpur, 1902 Prior to 1907 title reads: Beport on Government charitable dispensaries. ---- Jersey City, New Jersey. Jersey City, N. J. Jersey Citv Charity Hospital. Medical and surgical report, from its organization, 1S69. to May, 1X76 [55p.] 8? X. V., 1S77. Jersey City, X. J. Jersey City Christ Hospital. Annual report. Jersev City, 17.-43., 1X90-1916. Jersey City, X. J. St Francis Hospital. Annual report. Jersev Citv, l.-ll.. 1873-83; 13.-22., 1S85-94; 24., 1896; 26., 1898; 29.-36., 1902-9. ---- Kaifeng, China. Kaifeng, China. China Inland Mission Hospital. Report [Kaifeng] 1914; 1916-19; 192021; 1924; 1926. ---- Kansas City, Kansas. Kansas City, Kans. Bethany Hospital. Annual report. Kansas City, 7., 1898/99; 9., 1900. Kansas City, Kans. St Margaret's Hospi- tal. Report (annual, biennial, & triennial) Kansas Citv, 3.-11., 1SS9 97; 17., 1903 4' 1905 33. ---- Kansas City, Missouri. Kansas City, Mo. Agnkw Hospital. An- nual report. Kansas Citv, 6., 1*9*; X. <) 1901/2-1902/3. ---- Karlsruhe, Germany. Karlsruhe, Germany. Evangelische Dia- konissen-Anstalt. Jahresbericht. Karlsruhe 1861; 1862/63; 1X07/0S; 1X71/72; 1889/90; 1S92/93- 1904/5; 1908/9. ---- Kashmir, India. Kashmir, India. Kashmir Medical Mis- sion of the Church Missionary Society. Report. Mysore, 1916-21; 1923- ---- Keene, New Hampshire. Keene, N. H. Elliot City Hospital. Report, Keene, 1.-21., 1892/93-1915. ---- Kilmarnock, Ireland. Kilmarnock, Ireland. Kilmarnock In- firmary. Annual report of the directors to the subscribers. Kilmarnock, 1.-28., 1868-69 to 1895-96; 30., 1897-98; 34., 1901-2; 35., 1902-3. ---- Kingston, New York. Kingston, N. V. Kingston Hospital. nual report, Kingston, 1930-31. An- ---- Knoxville, Tennessee. Knoxville, Tenn. Knoxville General Hospital. Annual report. Knoxville, 8.-10., 1909/10-1911/12. ---- K0benhavn, Denmark. K0BENHAVN, DENMARK. KoLONIEN I'lLADEL- fia. Laegelig aaisberetning. Kbh., 1922/23; 1928/29. K0BENHAVN, DENMARK. KySTHOSPITALET. Aarsberetning. Kbh., 1902. K0BENHAVN, DENMARK. St. JOSEPHS HOS- PITAL. Beretning om patienter behandlct paa Karen M. Andersons Klinik. Kbh., 1901; 1918/22. K0BENHAVN, DENMARK. St. LUKAS StIK- telsens Hospital. Beretning om Hospitalets Virksomhed [Kbh.] 1916/17; 1918/19; 1921-22; 1924; 1926-27. K0benhavn, Denmark. Samfindet og Hjemmet for Vanf0res Klinik. Laegeberet- ning [Kbh.l 1922-24; 1930. Pers, A. Ottende aarsberetning fra Dr Alfred Pers' privat- klinik, 1908. Ugeskr. laeger, 1909, 71 : Suppl. 43. ---- Lancaster, Pennsylvania. ''Lancaster, Pa. Lancaster General Hos- pital. Annual report, Lane, 1897/98-1898/99; 19., 1911/12; 31.-41., 1924/25-1934/35; 43., 1935/37; 1939/40. Within these walls. 32p. 4° Lancaster, 1940. ---- Lawrence, Massachusetts. Lawrence, Mass. Lawrence General Hos- pital. Annual report. Lawrence, 1., 1875/76; 11.-32., 1885/X6-1906/7; 44.-45., 1918/19- 1919/20; 49., 1923/24. HOSPITAL REPORT 841 HOSPITAL REPORT --- Leamington, England. Leamington, Engl. Leamington Provi- dent Dispensary. Annual report. Leamington, 1., 1869-1921; 1927-29; 1931-34; 1936- --- Lebanon, Pennsylvania. Lebanon, Pa. Good Samaritan Hospital. Annual report, Lebanon, 3.-17., 1888/89- 1904/5. --- Lecco, Italy. Lecco, Italy. Ospitale Civile di Lecco. Rendiconto clinico dell'ospitale di Lecco dal 1° Ottobrc 1900 al 31 Dicembre 1902. Lecco, 1903. --- Leeds, England. Leeds, England. Leeds Public Dispen- sary. Annual report, Leeds,1881/82-1884/85; 1886/87-1902/3; 1904/5-1907/8; 1909/10; 1912/13-13/14; 1915/16-1916/17; 1919/20- 1921/22; 1931/32. --- Lewiston, Maine. Lewiston, Maine. Central Maine Gen- eral Hospital. Annual report, Lewiston, 1.-16., 1891/92-1906/7. --- Lexington, Kentucky. Lexington, Ky. Good Samaritan Hospital. Annual report. Lexington, 1.-2., 1899-1900; 4., 1902. --- London, England. London, England. German Hospital, DAls- ton. Annual report. Lond., 1845/46-1849/50; 1851; 1854; 1857-95; 1897-1900; 1906; 1909-11. London, England. Guy's Hospital. Re- ports. Lond., 1892-1912; 1914-18. Report for 1893 contains index to reports from 1836-93. Report for 1918, v.70, is War Memorial number. London, England. St George's Hospital. Reports from the clinical and research labora- tories. Lond., 1910. London, England. Saint Peter's Hospital. Annual report, Lond., 1879-80; 1908-10; 1912; 1914-17;1920. London, England. University College or Xorth London Hospital. Report, [Lond.] 1868-73; 1875-82; 1885-87; 1890; 1892-95; 1898-1905; 1921-23. London, England. West London Hos- pital. Annual report, Lond., 1879-1905; 1909-14;1918-19. --- Long Branch, New Jersey. Long Branch, N. J. Monmouth Memorial Hospital. Annual report, Long Branch, 2.-20., 1891-1909. --- Long Island City, New York. Long Island City, N. Y. St. John's Long Island City Hospital. Annual report, Long Island City, 13.-16., 1904-7; 19.-22., 1910-13. --- Los Angeles, California. Los Angeles County, General Hospital. Annual report. Los Ang., 1916/17; 1937/38. --- Loughborough, England. Loughborough, England. Loughborough and district General Hospital and Dis- pensary. Annual report [Loughborough] 1885- 88;1890-1905; 1907-12; 1914-16; 1918. ---- Louisville, Kentucky. Louisville, Ky. John N. Norton Memo- rial Infirmary. Annual report. Louisville liS; il8!^. 5" i89°; 9-13- 1894-98' '^ ---- Lowell, Massachusetts. Lowell. Mass. Lowell Hospital. Report from 1840 to 1849. 16p. 8? Lowell, 1X49. Lowell, Mass. Lowell General Hos- pital. Annual report, Lowell, 1., 1893/95' 1903/4; 1906/7. ' Lowell, Mass. St John's Hospital. An- nual report, Lowell, 5., 1871/72; 7., 1873/74' 12., 1878/79; 14.-17., 1880/81-1883/84; 24.! 1890/91; 27., 1893/94; 29.-32., 1895/96-1898/99; 39.-40., 1906-8; 42.-43., 1909-10; 45., 1912-13. —-- Lynn, Massachusetts. Lynn, Mass. Lynn Hospital. Annual re- port, Lynn, 1.-4., 1883/84-1885/86; 6.-13., 1888-1915; 39.-41., 1921-23; 58., 1940- ---- Macerata, Italy. Esposito, G. Relazione sull'andamento del Manicomio provinciale di Macerata per gli anni 1908-9. Macerata, 1910. ---- McKeesport, Pennsylvania. McKeesport, Pa. McKeesport Hospital. Annual report. McKeesport, 1904/5; 1937/38- ---- Madras Presidency, India. Madras Presidency, India. Surgeon-Gen- eral's Office. Report (annual and triennial) on the working of the Civil Hospitals and Dis- pensaries. Madras, 1885; 1892-1909; 1911-14; 1916-1933; 1935- ---- Maiden, Massachusetts. Malden, Mass. Malden Hospital. An- nual report. Maiden, 1.-17., 1892/93-1908/9. ---- Manchester, England. Manchester, England. Manchester Royal Infirmary and Manchester Royal Mental Hospital. Report, Manchester, 1853/54; 1860/61-64/65; 1866/67-1.907; 1909-1928. Prior to 1923, reads: Manchester Royal Infirmary, Dis- pensary, and Royal Lunatic Hospital. ---- Manchester, New Hampshire. Manchester, N. H. Sacred Heart Hos- pital. Annual report. Manchester, 1909-13. ---- Manila. Manila, Philippine Islands. Philippine General Hospital. Annual report of the Director. Manila, 1917/18; 1920-32. ---- Marash, Turkey. Krankenhausbericht aus Marasch iiber das Arbeilsjahr 190G-7. Aerztl. Mission, Gutersloh, 1908 3: 58-61. ---- Meadville, Pennsylvania. Meadville, Pa. Meadville City Hospital and Training School for Nurses. Annual report. Meadville, 18.-23., 1898/99-1903/4. The 18th report is marked: First annual report; i. e., it was the first printed report. ---- Melbourne, Australia. Melbourne Hospital. Clinical reports. Melb., v.6, 1935- HOSPITAL REPORT 842 HOSPITAL REPORT --- Melrose, Massachusetts. Melrose, Mass. Melrose Hospital As- sociation. Annual report. Melrose, 3.-12., 1895/96-1904/5. --- Miami, Florida. Miami, 1 la. Jackson Memorial Hospital. Bulletin. Miami, v.3, Xo. 1, 1941- --- Milford, Massachusetts. Milford, Mass. Milford Hospital. An- nual report. Milford, 8.-20., 1910/11-1922; 36., 1938- --- Milwaukee, Wisconsin. Milwaukee, Wis. Milwaukee County Hospital. Annual report. Milwaukee, 1888- 94; 45., 1896-97; 1900-4. Milwaukee, Wis. Milwaukee Hospital. Report. Milwaukee, 1894-98; 1903-4. --- Minneapolis, Minnesota. Minneapolis, Minn. Minneapolis General Hospital. Annual report, Minneapolis, 1933. Minneapolis, Minn. Minneapolis City Hospital. Annual report. Minneapolis, 2.-3., 1889-1890; 7.-11., 1894-98; 1911-13; 1915-18. From 1911, reads: Minneapobs City Hospitals. Fahr. G. Report of the medical division. Annual Rep. Minneapolis Gen. Hosp., 1933, 3: 186-91. ---- Monroe, Louisiana. Monroe, La. St Francis Sanitarium. An- nual report. Monroe, 1., 1913/14. --- Montclair, New Jersey. Montclair, N. J. Mountainside Hospital. Annual report. Montclair, 1.-14., 1890/91-1904. ---- Montevideo, Uruguay. Montevideo. Hospital Pereira Rossell. Archivos. Montev., v.l, 1938- ---- Montreal, Canada. Montreal, Canada. Montreal General Hospital. Annual report. Montreal, 36.-75., 1857/58-1896/97; 77.-81., 1898/99-1902; 103., 1924; 105., 1926. Montreal, Canada. Royal Victoria Hos- pital. Annual report. Montreal, 1.-5., 1894- 1898. --- Morristown, New Jersey. Morristown, N. J. Hospital of St Barna- bas. Annual report. Morristown, 32.-36., 1897/98-1901/2; 38.-39., 1903/4-1904/5. Morristown, N. J. Morristown Memorial Hospital. Annual report. Morristown, 1., 1894- --- Mount Vernon, New York. Mount Vernon, N. Y. Mount Vernon Hospital. Annual report. Mount Vernon (1934) 1935- --- Mysore State, India. Mysore State, India. General and Reve- nue Departments. Report on the working of the hospitals and dispensaries. Bangalore, 1922- 1934. Continued as: Mysore State, India. Annual report of the Medical Department, 1935-37. Mysore State, India. Medical Depart- ment. Annual report. Bangalore, 1935-37. Preceded by: Mysore State, India. General and Revenue Departments; report on the working of the hospitals and dis- pensaries, 1922-34. ---- Nanking, China. Nanking, China. University of Nanking. Hospital. Annual report. Shanghai, 1917-22. ---- Napoli, Italy. Napoli. Ospedale degl' incurabili. An- nan clinici. Nap., v.1-2, 1835-36; v.5-7,1839-41. ---- Nashua, New Hampshire. Nashua, N. H. St Joseph's Hospital. An- nual report. Nashua, 1.-8., 1908/9-1915/16; 1918-23. ---- Natal, South Africa. Natal, South Africa. Natal Government Asylum. Report of the medical superintendent. Pietermaritzburg, 1901-5; 1908. ---- Natick, Massachusetts. Natick, Mass. Leonard Morse Hospital. Annual report. Natick, 7.-16., 1899-1908. ---- Newark, New Jersey. Newark, N. J. Hospital of St Barnabas, and for Women and Children. Annual report. Newark, 1.-2., 1866/67-1867/68; 4.-9., 1869/70- 1874/75; 16., 1881/82; 46., 1911/12; 50.-51., 1915/16-1916/17; 54.-61., 1920-27; 64., 1930- Prior to 1930, reads: Hospital of St Barnabas. Newark, N. J. Newark Beth Israel Hos- pital. Annual report. Newark, 1910/11; 1918/19-1919/20. Newark, N. J. Newark City Hospital. Annual report. Newark, 1.-10., 1883-92; 12.-19., 1894-1901; 21.-40., 1903-22; 42., 1924; 45.-47., 1927-29; 49., 1931; 51., 1933- Newark, N. J. Newark Memorial Hospital and Dispensary. Annual report. Newark, 42., 1912; 50.-51., 1918-19; 53., 1921. Prior to 1919, reads: Newark German Hospital and Dis- pensary. Newark, N. J. Presbyterian Hospital. Annual report. Newark, 1.-2., 1912/13; 5., 1916; 8.-23., 1919-34; 27., 1936- Newark, N. J. St James' Hospital. An- nual report. Newark, 1.-7., 1901-7; 9.-18., 1909-18; 20.-22., 1920-22; 30., 1933-34. Newark, N. J. St Michael's Hospital. Annual report. Newark, 8.-50., 1872-1916. ---- New Bedford, Massachusetts. New Bedford, Mass. St Luke's Hospital. Annual report. New Bedford, 13., 1896- ---- New Brighton, Staten Island, New York. New Brighton, Staten Island, N. Y. S. R. Smith Infirmary. Annual report. Tompkins- ville, Staten Island, 5., 1868/69; 8., 1871/72; 10., 1873/74; 12.-43., 1875/76-1906/7. New Britain, Connecticut. New Britain, Conn. New Britain General Hospital. Annual report. New Britain, 1.-8., 1899/1900-1906/7; 10., 1908/9: 14., 1912/13 17., 1915/16. Newburgh, New York. Newburgh, N. Y. St Luke's Hospital. Annual report. Newburgh, 1., 1858/59; 23., 1896/97; 25.-26., 1898/99-1899/1900; 30., 1903/4; 32.-34., 1905/6-1907/8. HOSPITAL REPORT 843 HOSPITAL REPORT --- Newburyport, Massachusetts. Newburyport, Mass. Anna Jaques Hos- pital. Annual report. Newburyport, 1., 1885; 10.-11., 1894-95; 16., 1900; 18., 1902; 25., 1909; 27., 1911. ---• New Haven, Connecticut. New Haven, Conn. General Hospital Society of Connecticut and New Haven Dispensary. Annual report. New Haven, 42., 1868/69- Prior to 1927, reads: General Hospital Society of Connecti- cut. New Haven, Conn. Hospital of St Ra- phael. Annual report. New Haven, 1.-24., 1910-31; 31., 1937. New Haven, Conn. New Haven Dis- pensary. Annual report. New Haven, 2.-3., 1872/73-1873/74; 6.-27., 1876/77-1897/98; 1926/27. --- New London, Connecticut. New London, Conn. Memorial Hospital Association. Annual report. New London, 3.-6., 1895/96-1898/99; 8.-16., 1900/1-1908/9; 18.-20., 1910/11-1912/13; 22., 1914/15. --- New Orleans, Louisiana. New Orleans, La. Charity Hospital. Annual report. New Orleans, 1842; 1853; 1856- 59; 1861; 1871-75; 1879- New Orleans, La. Touro Infirmary and Hebrew Benevolent Association of New Orleans. Annual report of the officers to the members and patrons of the association. N. Orl., 29., 1902-3. --- Newport, Rhode Island. Newport, R. I. Newport Hospital. An- nual report. Newport, 1.-3., 1873/4-1875/76; 5.-6., 1877/78-1878/79; 9.-30., 1881/82-1902/3; 32., 1904/5- --- Newton, Massachusetts. Newton, Mass. Newton Hospital. An- nual report. Newton, 7.-26., 1885/86-1906; 28., 1908- Prior to 1894, reads: Newton Cottage-Hospital Corporation. --- New York, New York. New York, N. Y. Bellevue and Allied Hospitals. Annual report. N. Y., 1.-27., 1902-28. New York, N. Y. Beth Israel Hospital. Annual report. N. Y., 1.-15., 1891/92-1903/4; 17.-18., 1905/6-1906/7; 20., 1908/9. New York, N. Y. Broad Street Hospital. Annual reports. N. Y., 1., 1917/18; 5., 1922. Now called: Downtown Hospital. New York, N. Y. Charles B. Towns Hospital. A symposium of medical opinion ... concerning the definite work of the Charles B. Towns Hospital (8]p. 23cm. N. Y. [1940] New York, N. Y. Columbus Hospital. Annual report. N. Y., 1.-13., 1896-1908. New York, N. Y. Demilt Dispensary. Annual report. N. Y., 1.-52., 1851-1902; 56., 1906; 58.-60.. 1908-10; 62., 1912; 64.-65., 1914- 15; 69., 1919. New York, N. Y. Department of Hos- pitals. Abbreviated report. N. Y., 1935- ---- Annual report. N. Y., 1. (1929) 1930- New York, N. Y. General Memorial Hospital. Annual report. N. Y., v.14-29, 1898-1913. New York, N. Y. Good Samaritan Dis- pensary. Annual report. N. Y.. 1-8 1891- 98; 27., 1917. ' " ' New York, N. Y. Jews' Hospital. Annual report. N. Y., v.2-11, 1856-65. New York, N. Y. J. Hood Wright Memo- rial Hospital. Annual report. N. Y., 33 -44 1896-1907. ' ' New York, N. Y. Knickerbocker Hospital. Annual report. N. Y., 75., 1937. New York, N. Y. Lebanon Hospital Asso- ciation. Annual report. N. Y., 1.-3., 1890- 1896/97; 9., 1902/3; 15.-17., 1908/9-1910/11; 21., 1915. ' New York, N. Y. Lenox Hill Hospital. Annual report. N. Y., 1.-3., 1870-72; 5.-9., 1874-78; 13.-48., 1882-1917; 49., 1918- Prior to 1918, was called: German Hospital and Dispensary. New York, N. Y. Lincoln Hospital & Home. Annual report. N. Y., 13., 1852/53; 15., 1854/55; 20.-21., 1859/60-1860/61; 25., 1864/65; 27.-35., 1866/67-1874/75; 37.-38., 1876/77-1877/78; 40.-61., 1879/80-1900/1; 62.- 83., 1901/2-1922. Prior to 1901/2, was called: Colored Home and Hospital. New York, N. Y. Lutheran Hospital Association. Annual report. N. Y., v. 10-18, 1889/90-1897/8. New York, N. Y. Misericordia Hospital. Annual report. N. Y., 10.-18., 1896/97-1904/5; 20.-25., 1906/7-1911/12; 27., 1913/14; 29., 1915/16; 31.-32., 1917/18-1918/19. Prior to 1903/4, was: New York Mothers' Home of the Sisters of Misericorde. New York, N. Y. Montefiore Hospital. Fannie Hurst visits Montefiore. 36p. 4? N. Y., [1935] New York, N. Y. Montefiore Hospital for Chronic Diseases. Montefiore digest; 5- year report, 1935-39. 104p. 19^cm. N. Y., 1939. New York, N. Y. Mount Sinai Hospital. Annual report. N. Y., 12.-61., 1866-1912/13; 64., 1915/16; 66., 1918- New York, N. Y. New York Dispensary. Annual report. N. Y., 40.-42., 1829-31; 44., 1833; 47.-48., 1836-37; 50., 1839; 52.-53., 1841- 42; 55.-66., 1844-55; 68.-115., 1857-1904. New York, N. Y. New York Foundling Hospital. Biennial report. N. Y., 1892-1921. New York, N. Y. New York Infirmary for Women and Children. Annual report. N. Y., 14., 1867- New York, N. Y. New York Medical College and Flower Hospital. Bulletin. N. Y., v. 1, 1938- New York, N. Y. New York Post-Gradu- ate Medical School and Hospital. Annual report. N. Y., 1., 1882/3- New York, N. Y. North-Eastern Dis- pensary. Annual report. N. Y., 3., 1864; 5.-6., 1866-67; 8.-12., 1869-73; 15.-23., 1876-84; 25- 60., 1886-1921; 66.-69., 1927-30. New York, N. Y. Northern Dispensary. Annual report. N. Y., 3., 1829/30; 9., 1835/36; 14.-17., 1840/41-1843/44; 19., 1845/46; 21., 1847/48; 22.-94., 1849-1921; 99.-102., 1925-28; 104., 1930; 106.-108., 1932-34; 111.-112., 1937- 38 New York, N. Y. North-Western Dis- pensary. Annual report. N. Y., 1.-8., 1852/53- 1860; 10., 1862; 12.-16., 1864-68; 18.-46., 1870- 98; 48.-49., 1900-1; 51.-55., 1903-7; 57.-58. 1909-10; 60., 1912. HOSPITAL REPORT S44 HOSPITAL REPORT New York, N. Y. Presbyterian Hospital. Annual report. X. Y., 1. 58., 1868-1926; 60., 1928- Xew York, N. Y. Reconstruction Hospi- tal. Annual report. X. Y., 1920/21-1921/22. New York, X. Y. Roosevelt Hospital. Annual report, X. V., 1.-64.. 1871/72 1935; 67., 1938; 69., 1940. New York, X'. Y. St Francis' Hospital. Annual report, X. Y., 6.-11., 1872-77; 17.-57., 1882 1922; 62.-69., 1927-34; 71.-74., 1936-39. New York, X. Y. St John's Guild. Annual report. X.Y., 1877 79 1917/18;55.-73., 1920/21- 1939. New York, X. Y. St Luke's Hospital. Annual report. X. Y.. 1.-79., 1858-1937. New York, X'. Y. St Mark's Hospital. Annual report. X. Y., 1.-10., 1890/91-1899/1900; 12.-17., 1901/2-1906/7. Xew York, X. Y\ St Mary's Hospital. Annual report. Brooklyn, X. Y\, 1.-6., 1883-88; 1893-95; 1898; 1901-4; 1906; 28., 1908; 32.-39., 1913-20. Xew York, X'. Y. St Vincent's Hospital. Annual report. X. Y.. 1.. 1858; 2., 1859-60; 13., 1862; 16. 25., 1864-1873 74; 32.-33., 1880/81- 1882; 35., 1884; 37., 1886; 48. 53., 1897-1902; 55.-60., 1904-9; 85., 1934- ---- Bulletin. X. Y., v.l, 1934- New York, N. Y. Society of the New York Hospital. Annual report. N. Y., 69.-91., 1839-61; 93.-94., 1863-64; 96.-98., 1866-68; 101., 1871- Prior to 1893, reads: New York Hospital and Bloomingdale Asylum. Xew York, N. Y. Stuyvesant Square Hospital. Annual report. N. Y"., 1., 1883- --- Xew Zealand. Xew Zealand. Department of Health. Annual report of the Director-General of Health [Wellington] 1917/18- Prior to 1920-21, was: Public Health and Hospitals and Charitable Aid. Report thereon by the Chief Health Officer and the Inspector-General of Hospitals and Charitable Institu- tions. ---- Appendix to the annual report. Welling- ton. 1., 1916/17-1919/20; 1921/22-1929/30. ---- Norristown, Pennsylvania. Norristown, Pa. Charity Hospital. An- nual report. X'orristown, 1.-14., 1889 1902; 16.. 1904. X'orristown, Pa. Montgomery Hospital. Service record. Norristown, 1933/34- ---- North Adams, Massachusetts. North Adams, Mass. North Adams Hospi- tal. Annual report. Xorth Adams, 1.-22., 1884 85-1905/6. --- North-West Frontier Province, India. North-West Frontier Province, India. Inspector-General of Civil Hospitals. An- nual report on hospitals and dispensaries. Peshawar, 1902-3; 1905-34; 1936- --- Norway. Norway. Statistiske Centralbyra. De spedalske i Xorge; beretning. Oslo (1906/10- 1921/25) 1912-27. --- Norwich, Connecticut. Norwich, Conn. William W. H \< kus Hos- pital. Annual report, Norwich, 1.-5., 1893/94- 1807 98; 7. 11., 189') 1900 1903/1; 13.-11 1905,6 1906/7. ---- Novara, Italy. Novara, Italy. Mankomio Provin< iale di Novara. Relazione sulla gestionc sanitaria del anno 1901; note cliniche e quadri statistici. Novara, 1903. ---- Nova Scotia, Canada. Nova Scotia, Canada. Nova Scotia Hos- pital. Annual report, Halifax, 54., 1910/11- 62., 1919/20; 64.-78., 1920/21 1934/35. 62. is for 1919-20, and 64. is for 1920-21. There is no report numbered 63 --- Omaha, Nebraska. Omaha, Nebr. Nebraska Methodist Epis- copal Hospital and Deaconess Home. Annual report. Omaha, 1916/17. Omaha, Nebr. St Joseph's Hospital. Annual report. Omaha, 17., 1896; 19.-42 1898-1921. Known also as: Creighton Memorial. ---- Ontario, Canada. Ontario. Inspector of Prisons and Public Charity. Annual report upon the hospitals of the province of Ontario. Toronto, 24., 1892/93; 31., 1899/1900; 34., 1902/3. ---- Orange, New Jersey. Orange, N. J. Orange Memorial Hospital. Annual report. Orange, 10.-11., 1882-83; 14.-15., 1887-88; 17., 1890- --- Orissa, India. Orissa, India. Director of Health and Inspector-General of Prisons. Report (an- nual and triennial) on the working of the hospi- tals and dispensaries. Cuttack, 1936- For earlier numbers, see: Bihar and Orissa. Inspector- General of Civil Hospitals. --- Oslo, Norway. Oslo, Norway. Kommunale Sykehuse. Meddelelser [Oslo] 1921-30. --- Paignton, England. Paignton, England. American Women's War Hospital. Analysed report of the first thousand cases treated [Paignton] [1915] --- Paisley, Scotland. Paisley, Scotland. Royal Alexandra In- firmary. Annual report. Paisley, 1906-13; 1915-18; 1921-28. --- Paotingfu, China. Paotingfu, China. Taylor Memorial Hos- pital, Presbyterian Mission. Report. Peking, 1920. --- Papeete, Takiti. Torry, E. Hopital colonial, Papeete, Tahiti. Trained Nurse, 1938, 100: 1.52-5. ---- Parma, Italy. Monguidi, C. Ospedale maggiore di Parma; il triennio 1901-3; rendiconto statistico. 8? Parma, 1904. ---- Passaic, New Jersey. Passaic, N. J. St Mary's Hospital. An- nual report. Passaic, 40., 1935. HOSPITAL REPORT 845 HOSPITAL REPORT --- Paterson, New Jersey. Paterson, N. J. Paterson General Hos- pital. Annual report. Paterson, 16.-18., 1887-89; 20.-22., 1890-92; 24.-45., 1894-1915 69., 1939. Prior to 1905, reads: Paterson General Hospital Association. Paterson, N. J. St Joseph's Hospital. Annual report. Paterson, 1.-6., 1867/68- 1872/73; 22.-26., 1889-93; 28.-34.. 1895-1901; 36.-41., 1903-8; 49., 1916. --- Peiping, China. Peiping, China. Peiping Union Medical College Hospital. Annual report of the superintendent, Peiping, 1911/12-14/15; 1916/17-20/21; 1922/23-38/39. --- Philadelphia, Pennsylvania. Philadelphia, Pa. American Oncologic Hospital. Annual report. Phila., 1.-20., 1905-24. Philadelphia, Pa. Charity Hospital. An- nual report. Phila., 10.-11., 1867-68; 13.-14., 1870/71-1871/72; 17., 1875/76; 33., 1893/94; 58., 1918 Philadelphia, Pa. Christ Church Hos- pital. Annual report. Phila., 1883/84; 1885/86- 1906/7; 1908/9-1914/15. Philadelphia, Pa. German Hospital. An- nual report. Phila.. 10.-56., 1869-1915. Philadelphia, Pa. Germantown Dispen- sary and Hospital. Annual report. Phila., 15.-36., 1878-99; 38., 1901; 40., 1903. Philadelphia, Pa. Gynecean Hospital. Annual report. Phila., 3.-15., 1889/90-1901/2. Philadelphia, Pa. Hospital of the Protes- tant Episcopal Church. Annual report. Phila., 3.-5., 1854-56; 9.-49., 1860-1900; 53.-70., 1905-21; 85., 1936- Philadelphia, Pa. Hospital of the Uni- versity of Pennsylvania. Annual report. Phila., 1.-9., 1875-83; 11., 1885; 13.-20., 1887-94; 22.-43., 1896-1916/17; 45.-47., 1918/19-1920/21; 50.-51., 1923/24-1924/25; 53., 1926/27; 55.-57., 1928/29-1930/31; 61., 1934/35; 67., 1940/41. Philadelphia, Pa. Howard Hospital. An- nual report. Phila., 6.-7., 1859/60-1860/61; 9.-14., 1862/63-1867/68; 16.-21., 1869/70- 1874/75; 23., 1867/77; 31., 1884/85; 34.-47., 1887/88-1900/1; 49.-50., 1902/3-1903/4; 56.-62., 1909/10-1915/16. Philadelphia, Pa. Jefferson Hospital. Annual report. Phila., 17.-23., 1894-1900; 33.-34., 1909/10-1910/11; 38., 1914/15; 40., 1916/17; 42.-49., 1918/19-1925/26; 53., 1929/30; 55., 1931/32- Nos, 17.-23. read: Jefferson Medical College Hospital. Philadelphia, Pa. Jewish Hospital As- sociation. Annual report. Phila., 1., 1865; 4.-7., 1868-71; 9.-37., 1873-1901/2; 39.-41., 1903/4-1905/6; 44.-45., 1908/9-1909/10; 47.-48., 1911/12-1912/13; 52.-56., 1916/17-1920/21; 58.- 59., 1922/23-1923/24; 65., 1929/30. Philadelphia, Pa. Lankenau Hospital. Annual report. Phila., 58., 1917- Philadelphia, Pa. Medico-Chirurgical Hos- pital. Annual report. Phila., 12., 1896; 16., 1900; 18.-19., 1902-3; 28.-30., 1910-13; 32.-33., 1913/14-1915/16. For later reports, see: Philadelphia, Pa. University of Penn- sylvania. Hospitals of the Graduate School of Medicine. Philadelphia, Pa. Methodist Episcopal Hospital. Annual report. Phila., 1.-18., 1887- 1904. Philadelphia, Pa. Northern Dispensary of Philadelphia for the Medical Relief of the Poor. Annual report. Phila., 1 1816 26--30 1841-45; 34., 1849; 36., 1851; 37.-38. I*52"53; 40.-43., 1855-58; 45.-48., 1860-63 50.-55., 1865-70; 57.-59., 1872-74; 61-63 1875-78; 65.-86., 1880-1901; 90.-92, 1905-7 94.-95., 1909-10; 100., 1915. Philadelphia, Pa. Northwestern General Hospital. Annual report. Phila., 3., 1910/11. Philadelphia, Pa. Pennsylvania Hospital Annual report. Phila., 1.-5., 1750-54; 95-99' 1844/45-1848/49; 101.-102., 1850/5l-1851/52: 104.-181., 1853/54-1931/32; 185., 1935/36- Philadelphia, Pa. Philadelphia. Dispen- sary for the Medical Relief of the Poor Annual report, Phila., 1815; 1827-28; 1830-31 1833-35; 1837-39; 1841-47; 1849; 1858-59 186162; 1864; 1866; 1868-76; 1878; 1881-87 1889-95; 1897-1917. Philadelphia, Pa. Philadelphia General Hospital. Report. Phila., v.l, 1890- Philadelphia, Pa. Presbyterian Hospital. Annual report. Phila., 1.-36., 1871-1906; 41,-43., 1911-13; 45.-48., 1915-18; 64.-65., 1934-35; 67.-68., 1937-38. Philadelphia, Pa. St Agnes' Hospital. Annual report. Phila., 1891-1907; 1910-11. Philadelphia, Pa. St Joseph's Hospital. Annual report. Phila., 5.-10., 1853-1857/58; 11.-47., 1859-95; 49.-53., 1897-1901; 55.-60., 1903-8; 67.-70., 1915-18. Philadelphia, Pa. St Mary's Hospital. Annual report. Phila., 1.-9., 1867-76; 13.-19., 1880-86; 20. 1890-92; 1895-98; 1901-3, 1905- 1912/13. Philadelphia, Pa. Samaritan Hospital. Annual report. Phila., 4.-6., 1896-98; 8., 1900; 13.-15., 1905-7/8. Philadelphia, Pa. University of Pennsyl- vania. Hospitals of the Graduate School of Medicine. Bi-annual report. Phila., 1., 1918/19- 1920/21. Report covers two hospitals: Medico-Chirurgical Hospital, and Polyclinic Hospital. See also: Philadelphia, Pa. Medico-Chirurgical Hospital. Landis, H. R. M. An account of the first clinical reports issued from the Philadelphia Hospital. Philadelphia Hosp. Rep., 1905, 6: 1-4. --- Phoenix, Arizona. Phoenix, Ariz. Lois Grunow Memorial Clinic. The Lois Grunow Memorial Clinic [12]p. 2554cm. Phoenix, 1931. --- Pittsburgh, Pa. Pittsburgh, Pa. Allegheny General Hos- pital. Annual report [Pittsb.] 1.-14., 1885-99; 20., 1905; 22.-24., 1907-9; 36.-37., 1920/21- 1921/22; 39., 1923/24- Pittsburgh, Pa. Mercy Hospital. Report (annual and biennial) Pittsb., 1889/90-1922/24. Pittsburgh, Pa. Pittsburgh Diagnostic Clinic. Annual report. Pittsburgh (1935; 1936- ----The first decade, 1925-35. 22p. 8? [Pittsburgh, 1935] Pittsburgh, Pa. Pittsburgh Hospital. Report. Pittsb., 1907/11; 1913/16-1920/22. Pittsburgh, Pa. Presbyterian Hospital. Annual report. Pittsb., 2.-4., 1895-1898/99; 6., 1900/1; 11.-16., 1905/6-1910/11; 18.-20., 1912/13-1914/15; 22.-25., 1916/17-1919/20; 27., 1921/22; 39.-40., 1933/34-1934/35; 43.-44., 1937/38-1938/39. HOSPITAL REPORT 846 HOSPITAL REPORT Pittsburgh, Pa. Western Pennsylvania Hospital. Report. Pittsb., 1907/9-1916/18. --- Pittsfield, Massachusetts. Pittsfield, Mass. House of Mercy. An- nual report. Pittsfield, 4.-36., 1877/78-1909/10. ---- Plainfield, New Jersey. Plainfield, N. J. Muhlenberg Hospital. Annual report. Plainfield, 9.-33., 1889/90- 1913/14. ---- Poggibousi, Italy. Poggibotjsi, Italy. Ospedale Civile di Poggibousi. Rendiconto sanitario del sessennio 1896-1901. Poggibousi, 1903. ---- Pontremoli, Italy. Boni, C. Spedale di Pontremoli; resoconto per l'anno 1902. 8? Pontremoli, 1903. ---- Poppi, Italy. Paracca, E. Ospedale di G. Maria della Misericordia in Poppi; resoconto clinico-statistico della sezione medica e chirurgica 1896-1904. 8? Arezzo, 1905. ---- Portland, Maine. Portland, Me. Maine General Hospital. Annual report. Portland, 5.-37., 1874/75- 1906/7; 41.-42., 1910/11-1911/12; 54., 1923/24. ---- Portland, Oregon. Portland, Ore. Good Samaritan Hos- pital. Annual report. Portland, 1891/92- 1899/1900; 1911/12-1922; 1928; 1936; 1938. --- Portsmouth, New Hampshire. Portsmouth, N. H. Portsmouth Hos- pital. Annual report. Portsmouth, 1.-22., 1885/86-1906/7; 27., 1911/12. Reports 1.-22. read: Portsmouth Cottage Hospital. ---- Pottsville, Pennsylvania. Pottsville, Pa. Pottsville Hospital. An- nual report. Pottsville, 1., 1893/94; 2.-3., 1895/97-1897/99; 6.-11., 1900/1-1905/6. ---- Praha, Austria. Praha, Austria. K. K. Allgemeines Kran- kenhaus. Jahresbericht. Prag, 1898-1900; 1902-10. --- Proctor, Vermont. Proctor, Vt. Proctor Hospital. A gen- eral report from its institution to December 31, 1904 [Proctor, 1905] --- Punjab, India. Punjab, India. Inspector-General of Civil Hospitals. Report (annual and triennial) on the working of hospitals and dispensaries Lahore, 1894- Prior to 1932. was: Statements of Dispensaries and Chari- table Institutions. Punjab, India. Secretary to the Govern- ment. Triennial report on the working of hos- pitals and dispensaries in the Punjab (1932-34) Lahore, 1935. ---- Quebec, Canada. Quebec, Canada. Secretary's Department. Bureau of Statistics. Statistics of benevolent institutions. Quebec, 1928. ---- Queensland, Australia. Queensland, Australia. Home Secretary's Dept. Report upon the operations of the Sub- Departments of Aboriginals, Dunwich Benevo- lent Asylum [&c] Brisb., 1920-26. ---- Quincy, Illinois. Quincy, III. St Mary's Hospital. Annual report. Quincy, 1884; 1886; 1889; 1892; 1893; 32., 1897; 1908; 1915. ---- Quincy, Massachusetts. Quincy, Mass. Quincy City Hospital. An- nual report. Quincy, 1.-18., 1890-1907; 20., 1909; 22., 1911. ---- Radnor, Pennsylvania. Radnor, Pa. Hospital of the Good Shep- herd. Annual report. Radnor, 1.-32., 1873/74- 1906/7. --- Ramsey, Isle of Man. Ramsey, Isle of Man. Ramsey and Dis- trict Cottage Hospital. Report of the Com- mittee of Management [Ramsey] 1914/15- 1918/19. --- Reading, England. Reading, England. Royal Berkshire Hos- pital. Report. Reading, 1932-35. --- Reading, Pennsylvania. Reading, Pa. Reading Hospital. Annual report of the board of managers. Reading, 25.. 1891; 26., 1892. --- Richmond, Virginia. Richmond, Va. Memorial Hospital [Pros- pectus containing list of officers, board of trustees, medical staff [&c] charter and regulations] 37p. 8? Richmond, 1903. Richmond, Va. Old Dominion Hospital. Annual report of the officers to the board of managers. Richmond, 1.-6., 1895/96-1900/1. Richmond, Va. St Elizabeth's Hospital. Annual report. Richmond, 10., 1921. ---- Rochester, Minnesota. Rochester, Minn. St Mary's Hospital. Annual report. Rochester, 6.-35., 1895-1924; 38., 1927; 49., 1938- ---- Rochester, New York. Rochester, N. Y. Strong Memorial Hos- pital. Annual report. Rochester, 9., 1934/35- ----The first decade, 1926-36. 208p. 8? Rochester, 1936. ---- Providence, Rhode Island. Providence, R. I. Butler Hospital. Year book. Providence, 1847. ---- Annual report. Providence, 58., 1901- Formerly: Providence, R. I. Butler Hospital for the Insane. Providence, R. I. Charles V. Chapin Hospital. Annual report. Providence, 1.-21 1910-30; 22., 1931- Prior to 1931, was: Providence City Hospital. Providence, R. I. House of Providence Hospital. Annual report. Providence, 1.-2 1896/97-98. Providence, R. I. Rhode Island Hospital. Annual report. Providence, 1., 1864- Providence, R. I. St Joseph's Hospital, Annual report. Providence, 1., 1892/93- HOSPITAL REPORT 847 HOSPITAL REPORT ---- Rome, Georgia. Rome, Ga. Harbin Hospital. Biennial report. Rome, 3.-9., 1913/14-1925/26; 11., 1929/30- ---- Roseau, Dominica. Roseau, Dominica. Roseau Hospital. Re- port [Roseau] 1904-12; 1914; 1917-21. --- Saint-Blaise, Switzerland. Saint-Blaise, Switzerland. Maison de SantI3 de Prefargier. Exercice ... rapport annuel. Saint-Blaise, 1873; 1876-1903; 1905; 1910-12. --- St John's, Newfoundland. St John's Newfoundland. St John's General Hospital. Annual report. St John's, N. F., 1922/23-1924/25; 1927/28. --- St Louis, Missouri. St Louis, Mo. Barnes Hospital. Annual report. S. Louis, 1., 1915/16; 1920-29. St Louis, Mo. Evangelical Deaconess Motherhouse and Evangelical Deaconess Hospital. Annual report. S. Louis, 16., 1905; 18., 1907. Report for 1905 reads: Evangelical Deaconess Home and Hospital.' St Louis, Mo. Missouri Pacific Hospital Association. Annual report. S. Louis, 12., 1924; 18., 1930- St Louis, Mo. Saint Luke's Hospital. Annual report. S. Louis, 24.-26., 1890-92; 30., 1895/96; 37.-39., 1902/3-1904/5; 41.-43., 1906/7- 1908/9. --- St Paul, Minnesota. St Paul, Minn. St Joseph's Hospital. Annual report. S. Paul, 45., 1897/98; 49.-51., 1901-4; 55., 1906/8. St Paul, Minn. St Luke's Hospital. Annual report. S. Paul, 1891/2; 1894; 1908. --- Salem, Massachusetts. Salem, Mass. Salem Hospital. Report. Salem, 1.-25., 1874/75-1899; 28., 1902. --- Salford, England. Salford, England. Hospital Department. Annual report. Salford, 1900. --- San Antonio, Texas. San Antonio, Tex. Santa Rosa Infirmary. Annual report. San Antonio, 1923. --- San Francisco, California. San Francisco, Calif. St Luke's Hospital Annual report. S. Franc, 5.-9., 1889/90- 1893/94; 1895-96; 1899/1900; 31.-33., 1901/2- 1903/4; 36., 1906/7; 38., 1908/9. ---- San Jose, Costa Rica. San Jose, Costa Rica. Hospital de San Jose\ Anales. San Jose, t. 1, fase. 1-4, 1915/16; t. 2, fase. 1-3, 1916/17. ---- Saratoga Springs, New York. Saratoga Springs, N. Y. Saratoga Hos- pital. Annual report. Saratoga Springs, 1897- 99; 1901-8/9. --- Schenectady, New York. Schenectady, N. Y. Ellis Hospital. Rec- ?4 ^T,T933]31"32-33- 48P- 8? [Schenec" ---- Scranton, Pennsylvania. Scranton, Pa. Lackawanna Hospital Annual report. Scranton, 1874/75-99/1900 Scranton, Pa. Moses Taylor Hospital 19137/8 reP°rt' Scranton' 7'~16-' 1898/99- ---- Sewickley, Pa. Sewickley, Pa. Valley Hospital [*1907] Annual report. Sewickley, 26.-27., 1932-34. ---- Shanghai, China. Shanghai, China. Hospitals and Nursing Services Commission. Report. Shanghai 1930-31. & ' This report constitutes vol. 25, No. 1384 of The Municipal Li£lZ6tti6« Shanghai, China. Saint Luke's Hospital for Chinese. Annual report. Shanghai, 1918- 36. Report for 1923 reads: Statistics and Financial statement. ---- Shreveport, Louisiana. Shreveport, La. Shreveport Charity Hos- pital. Report. Shreveport, 1912/14-1914/16; 1920-23. ---- Sind, India. Sind, India. Director of Health Services and Inspector-General of Prisons. Report (annual and triennial) on the civil hospitals and dispensaries. Karachi, 1936-38. ---- Singapore, Straits Settlements. Singapore, Straits Settlements. Tan Tock Seng Hospital. Annual report. Singapore, 1935; 1937-38. ---- Sioux City, Iowa. Sioux City, Iowa. Samaritan Hospital. Annual report. Sioux City, 18.-25., 1892/93- 1899/1900;.27.-32., 1901/2-1906/7. ---- Somerville, Massachusetts. Somerville, Mass. Somerville Hospital. Annual report. Somerville, 4.-8., 1896-1900/1; 10., 1902/3; 14.-16., 1906/7-1908/9. ---- South Australia. South Australia. Inspector-General of Hospitals. Report. Adelaide, 9., 1922. Also contains report of the Mental Defectives Board for 1922. --- South Shields, England. South Shields, England. Ingham Infir- mary and South Shield sand Westoe Dis- pensary. Annual report. South Shields, 1885- 1919. ---- Springfield, Illinois. Springfield, III. St John's Hospital. Annual report. Springfield, 1899; 1904-6. ---- Springfield, Mass. Springfield, Mass. Mercy Hospital. An- nual report. Springfield, 1.-3., 1896/97-1899; 5.-6., 1901-2; 8.-10., 1904-6. Springfield, Mass. Springfield Hospital. Annual report. Springfield, 1889-92; 1895- 1897/98; 1899/1900; 1901/2; 1908/9. HOSPITAL REPORT --- Stockholm, Sweden. Stockholm, Sweden. Stockholm^ Stads Sjukhus-direktion (and) Stads Statistiska Kontor. Stockholms stads sjukvard (Service hospitalier de la ville) Stockh., 1.-6., 1933-38. ---- Sydney, Australia. Sydney, Australia. Royal Prince Alfred Hospital. Annual report. Sydney, 1888, 1S94. 1903-4, 1906-7, 1909-12, 1922-23, 1925. Note: Reports for 1888 and 1894 read: The Prince Alfred Hospital. ---- The Gazette. Sydney, Dec. S, 1902; Dec. 24, 1903; Mar. 30, 1904; July 29, 1904. Published quarterly. Sydney, Australia. Sydney Hospital. An- nual report. Sydney, 1876-82. 1911, 1922, 1924. Note: Prior to 1882 the title read: The Sydney Infirmary and Dispensary. --- Tacoma, Washington. Tacoma, Washington. St Joseph's Hospital. Annual report. Tacoma, 1897-1909. --- Taunton, Massachusetts. Taunton, Mass. Morton Hospital. Annual report. Taunton, 1.-26., 1888/89-1913/14; 28- 30., 1915/16-1917/18; 33.-35., 1920/21-1922/23. --- Terre Haute, Indiana. Terre Haute, Ind. St Anthony's Hospital. Annual report. Terre Haute, 1892-1900; 1904-8. --- Thirsk, England. Thirsk, England. Lambert Memorial Hospital. Annual report of the trustees. Thirsk, 1901-6; 1908-15; 1917-23; 1927-29. --- Thomasville, Georgia. Thomasville, Ga. John D. Archbold Memorial Hospital. Annual report. Thomas- ville, 1927-28;1938-39. --- Toledo, Ohio. Toledo, Ohio. St Vincent's Hospital. Annual report. Toledo, 1908-13; 1916. --- Tonsberg, Norway. Paus, N. [Report of the City Hospital of Tonsberg for 19-M] Norsk mag. hegevid., 1924, 85: 747-59. ---- Trenton, New Jersey. Trenton, N. J. Mercer Hospital. Annual report. Trenton, 2., 1896/97; 10.-25., 1901/2- 1917/17; 27., 1918/19; 29.-30., 1920/21-1921/22. Trenton, N. J. St Francis Hospital. Annual report. Trenton, 27., 1900; 29., 1902; 32., 1905; 35., 1908; 41.-43., 1914-16. ---- Troy, New York. Troy, N. Y. Samaritan Hospital. Annual report. Troy, 1., 1898/99; 3., 1900/1; 12., 1908- 1909; 38., 1935. ---- Udine, Italy. Berghinz. G. Ospedale civile di Udine; note cliniche, rendi- conto del II biennio 1901-2. Riv. veneta sc. med., 1903, 38: 422-6; 457. ---- Uleaborg, Finland. Gratschoff, L. Fr&n Ule&borgs Liinesjukhus; statistik II. Fin. lak. sail, hand., 1907. 49: 341-54. ---- Utica, New York. Utica, N. Y. St Luke's Home & Hospital. Annual report. Utica, 15.-16., 1883/84-1884785; 18.-23., 1886 87-1891/92; 25.-40., 1893/94-1908/9. HOSPITAL REPORT ---- Vestfold, Norway. Paus. N. [Annual report of the Vestfold Coinmunitx Hospitali Norsk mag. laegevid., 1925, N<>: 817 (il. ---- Vicksburg, Mississippi. Vicksburg, Miss. Mississippi State Cmah- ity Hospital. Biennial report. Vicksburg, 1902-3; 1912-13; 1916-23. ---- Victoria, British Columbia. Victoria, B. C. Provincial Royal Juhilkk Hospital. Annual report of the directors and officers to the subscribers and the public. Vic- toria, 1.-4., 1890/91-1893/94; 9.-13., 1898/99- 1902/3. ---- Waltham, Massachusetts. Waltham, Mass. Waltham Hospital. An- nual report. Waltham, 1.-37., 1SS7-1923; 38.-43., 1925/26-1930. ---Warren, Pennsylvania. Warren, Pa. Warren General Hospital. Annual report. Warren, 1.-3., 1901-3; 15.-25., 1911-1922/23; 29.-32., 1926/27-1929/30. Prior to 1919, was: Warren Emergency Hospital. ---- Washington, District of Columbia. Washington, D. C. Central Dispensary and Emergency Hospital. Annual report. Washington, D. C., 1., 1871/72; 5., 1877/78; 1879/80; 1881/82; 1884/86; 1894; 1896/97- 1897/98; 1899/1900-1909/10; 1919/20-1921/22; 1924/25-1926/37; 1932/33- Prior to 1881, was: Central Free Dispensary. Washington, D. C. Eastern Dispensary and Casualty Hospital. Annual report. Washington, D. C, 4., 1890/91; 9., 1896/97; 1902/3. Prior to 1902, reads: Eastern Dispensary of the District of Columbia. Washington, D. C. Freedmen's Hospital. Annual report. Washington, D. C, 1876/77- 1883/84; 1885/86-1927/28; 1929/30-1931/32. Washington, D. C. Garfield Memorial Hospital. Annual report. Washington, D. C, 1.-35., 1882-1916; 43.-56., 1924-37. Washington, D. C. Georgetown Univer- sity Hospital. Annual report. Washington. D. C, 1.-2., 1898/99-1899/1900; 1902; 1905; 1908; 1913. Washington, D. C. (!eorge Washington University Hospital. Annual report. Wash- ington, D. C, 1.-6., 1898-1903/4; 1912/13- 1916/17. Washington, D. C. Providence Hospital. Annual report. Washington, D. C, 1880/81; 33., 1894/95; 35.-39., 1896/97-1900/2; 41., 1904/5; 43., 1906/7; 45., 1908/9; 46.-48., 1910/11- 1914/15; 1922/23. Washington, D. C. Sibley Memorial Hos- pital. Annual report. Washington, D. C, 1., 1900/1; 1902/3-1906/7; 1913/14-1915/16; 1919/20. Washington, D. C. Washington Home for Incurables. Annual report. Washington, D. C, 1.-12., 1889/90-1901/2; 15.-20., 1904/5- 1910/11. ---- Waterbury, Connecticut. Waterbury, Conn. Waterbury Hospital. Annual report. Waterbury, 1.-12., 1890 1901; 16., 1905; 44., 1932/33. HOSPITAL REPORT 849 HOSPITAL SCIENCE --- Weihsien, Shantung, China. Weihsien, Shantung, China. American Presbyterian Hospital. Annual report [Weihsien] 1918-24. --- Welch, West Virginia. Welch, W. Va. West Virginia Miners' Hospital No. 1. Biennial report. Welch, 4., 1906/8. --- White Plains, New York. New York Hospital. Westchester Divi- sion. Annual report of the Medical Director. White Plains, N. Y., 1940- --- Wien, Austria. Nieder-Oesterreich. Statthalterei. Jahr- buch der Wiener k. k. Krankenanstalten. Wien, 8.-9. Jahrg. (1899-1900) 1902-3. Chronik [der Wiener Hospitaler] Jahrb. Wien. Kranken- anst. (1900) 1903, 9: 21-39. --- Wilkes-Barre, Pennsylvania. Wilkes-Barre, Pa. Mercy Hospital. Re- port. Wilkes-Barre, 1930/34- Wilkes-Barre, Pa. Wilkes-Barre City Hospital. Annual report. Wilkes-Barre:, 1879- 80; 1883; 1886-1902. --- Winnipeg, Manitoba. Winnipeg, Manitoba. Winnipeg General Hospital. Report and account [Winnipeg] 1924. --- Worcester, Massachusetts. Worcester, Mass. Memqrial Hospital. Annual report. Worcester, 1., 1888- Worcester, Mass. St Vincent's Hospital. Annual report, Worcester, 1.-9., 1894-1902; 11.-16., 1904-9. Worcester, Mass. Worcester City Hos- pital. Annual report. Worcester, 1., 1871- --- Wuchang, China. Wuchang, China. Church General Hos- pital. Report. Wuchang, 1919-25; 1927-38; 1940. --- Youngstown, Ohio. Youngstown, Ohio. Youngstown Hospital Association. Annual report. Youngstown, 22.-28., 1903/4-1909/10; 34., 1915/16. --- Yungchun, Fulien, China. YUNGCHUN, FUKIEN, CHINA. YUNGCHUN Hospital. Annual report. Shanghai, 1911/12- 1915/16. --- Zenkov, Russia. Petrovski, I. A. [Report of the Zenkov, Poltava Govern- ment, hospital for 23 years, 1858-1912] Vest. obsh. hig., 1913, 49: pt 2, 1-9. HOSPITAL science. Ketcham, D. Michigan hospital handbook. 412p. 21cm. Ann Arb., 1940. Drafts, reports, information; special council for study com- mittees, aims and objects. Nosokomeion, Stuttg., 1938, 9: 270-2.—Fietz, H. Die Schaffung eines Zentralarchives fur das schweizerische Krankenhauswesen. Schweiz. med. Wschr., 1939, 69: 727-9.—Golub, J. J. The study and superintendence of hospital procedures; suggesting the creation of a special committee of the medical staff and administrative officers tor the purpose. J. Am. M. Ass., 1939, 112: 417-20.—McCombs, C. E. The need of a research bureau for the hospitai held. Tr. Am. Hosp. Ass., 1929, 31: 231-43.—Riley, W A. Swedish hospital research and statistical bureau Hospitals, 1937, 11: No. 7, 23-6, 3 plans.—Sherrill, J. G. History and reason for 227475—vol. 7, 4th series----54 the organization of the Joint Hospital Committee. Kentucky M. J., 1930, 28: 367.—Soos, A. Reports, resolutions, proposals ot the study committees. Nosokomeion, Stuttg., 1937 8: t- 5'— V/rthi J", Dritter internationaler Fortbildungskursus YJ,-,,^ Krankenhauswesen. Zschr. ges. Krankenhauswes., 1937, 11-4. Periodicals. H6pital (L') Par., v.10, 1922- HORNSBY'S HOSPITAL MAGAZINE. Chic, V.l, 1921. Hospital (The) and health review. Lond., v.l, 1921- Hospital management; a practical journal of administration. Chic, v.l, 1915- Hospitals. Chic, v.10, 1936- Hospital topics and buyer; the friendly hospital journal. Chic, v.15, No. 4, 1937- Jahrbuch fiir das gesamte Krankenhauswesen. Berl., v.l, 1932- Nosokomeion. Stuttg., v.l, 1930- Western hospital review. Los Ang., v. 15, 1930- Zeitschrift fiir das gesamte Krankenhaus- wesen. Berl., v.22, 1926- Gammill, L. C. Are the hospital publications actually meeting the requirements of the small hospital? Tr. Am. Hosp. Ass., 1933, 35: 748-51.—Schoute, D. [The Ziekenhuis and its professional staff] Ned. tschr. geneesk., 1923, 67: pt 1, 1732-6. HOSPITALS; the journal of the American Hospital Association. Chic, v.10, 1936- HOSPITAL service. See also Group medicine, and all its subhead- ings. Brooklyn. Methodist Hospital of Brook- lyn. Procedure book. 3. ed. 335p. 23cm. Brooklyn, 1937. Garesche, E. F. Soul of the hospital. 207p. 8? Phila., 1928. Mountin, J. W., Pennell, _ E. H. [et al.] Selected characteristics of hospital facilities in 1936; trends in hospital development, 1928-36. 53p. 8? Wash., 1938. Trachte, H. Ueber Notwendigkeit, Be- griindung und Rechtfertigung einer grundlegen- den Aenderung der Verpflegung in Klinik und Krankenhaus und ihre Durchfiihrung. 48p. 22cm. Lpz., 1939. Actividades (As) do Hospital Miguel Pereira. Brasil med., 1940, 54: 185-8.—Alter, W. Grundsatzliche Richtlinien fur die Leistung am Kranken im Krankenhaus. Nosokomeion, Stuttg., 1933, 4: 258.—Black, B. W. Trends affecting hospital administration and service. Pacific Coast J. Nurs., 1941, 37: 526-31.—Block, L. Extent of the medical care facilities in institutions not registered with American Medical Association. Hospitals, 1942, 16: 91-7.—Brown. A. E. Hospital practice. Med. J. Australia, 1927, 1: 292-9.—Brush, F. How convales- cent and hospital care differ. Mod. Hosp., 1927, 28: No. 6, 86-8 —Burnham, F. What may a patient expect from the hospital? Hospitals, 1939, 13: No. 2, 107.—Changes in hospital service in 25-year period reviewed. J. M. Ass. Georgia, 1941, 30: 110.—Cushing, H. W. The personality of a hospital. In his Consecr. medici, Bost., 1940, 181-43.—Distinguished service; by courtesy and kindliness. .Mod. Hosp., 1935, 44: No. 6, 53-5.—Ellis.'B. L. An 8-hour day for patients. Canad. Nurse 1940 36: 11-3.—Emerson, H. Sixty improvements in hospital care. Mod. Hosp., 1937, 48: 67-71—Fike, O. K. Institutional personality. Hospitals, 1939, 13: No. 12, 91-4.— Fisher, D. E. Administration of a medical ward, functions and activities of the personnel. Am. J. Nurs., 1941 411: 1281-8 — Fisher, P. R. Hospital atmosphere. Maine M. J., 1938, 29: 2(jQ-7i—Function of the cottage hospital. Lancet, Lond., 1934 i- 1355.—Gordon, B. The hospital's personality and environment. Week. Roster, Phila., 1939-40, 35: 319-22. Also Pennsylvania M. J., 1940-41, 44: 23-5.—Harman N B. The modern hospital conception. Brit. M. J., 1926 2: 984-b — Hatfield. J. N. Institutional personality. Mod. Hosp., 1934, 43. si —Hays H. For the well-to-do patient wanting maxi- mum service. Hosp. Management, 1927, 23: No. 3 25-31 — Hospital service according to agencies concerned and types of service [registered hospitals] J. Am. M. Ass. 1940, 114: 1180- 2G0 —Jackson, J. A. The hospital in the light of its function. Hospitals, 1936, 10: No. 6, 40-3. Also Ment. Health Bull Danville, 1936, 14, 2: 6-10.—Kahn, M. H.. & frank, L. J. A HOSPITAL SERVICE 850 HOSPITAL SERVICE new function of the hospital. Med. Rev. of Rev., 1927, 33: 167-71.—Kleeberg. D. J. Ueber die nicht zum Heilplan gehorende Behandlung der Krankenhausinsassen. Zschr. ges Krankenhauswes., 1928, 24: 471-3.—Lewinski Corwin, E. H. The hospital with a soul. Nosokomeion, Stuttg., 1930, 1: 17-24.— Meadows, F. L. Making the patients feel at home. Hospitals, 1940, 14: No. 3, 124.—Nava, P. Conceito das relac5cs entre o hospital e o doente. Rev. mid. mun., Rio, 1941, 1: 542-59.—Rendschmidt, M. Die Gestaltung der Pflege- einheit im Grosskrankenhaus. Zschr. ges. Krankenhauswes., 1938, 533-5; 1939, 329.—Richardson, D. L. Primarv functions of a public hospital. Tr. Am. Hosp. Ass., 1936, 38: 819-26.— Skirving, R. S. On the body and soul of a hospital. Med. J. Australia, 1930, 2: 847-51.—Sloan. R. P. Extras in patient service. Mod. Hosp., 1940, 54: No. 1, 44-7.—Solomon. C. A plea for rational hospital prescribing. Bull. M. Soc. Co. Kings, 1941, 20: 154.—Spaekman, C. S. The approach to the patient in a general hospital. Occup. Ther. Rehabil., 1937, 16: 93-9.-—Tietze, A. Die Aufgaben eines neuzeithchen stadtischen Krankenhauses. Zschr. ges. Krankenhauswes., 1926, 22: 680.—Trolley (A) service of charts and dosages. Nurs. Times, Lond., 1939, 35: 1247.—Villar Andrade, F. Pequefieces. Rev. mex. cir., 1939, 7: 113-7.—Yaw, R. D. The patient's first hour. Hospitals, 1939, 13: No. 9, 35. ---- Admittance and discharge of patient. Alexander, V. R. Information for 10 purposes obtained at once; centralized clerical work on admission reduces to 61 operations what formerly averaged 549 long hand operations dailv at St Louis City Hospital. Hosp. Management, 1932, 34: 26-8.—Attack (An) on hospital waiting lists. Brit. M. J., 1942, 1: 161.—Bigelow, G. H. The second year of the Cornell pay clinic. Mod. Hosp., 1924, 22: 479-83.—Black, B. W. County hospitals should be maintained for indigents only. Hospitals, 1936, 10: No. 6, 38-40.—Chaddock, R. E., & Davis, M. M. Who should be pay clinic patients? study of patients treated at the Cornell Clinic, New York Citv. Boston M. & S. J., 1923, 189: 317-21.—Committee (A) looks at the central admitting office. Mod. Hosp. 1935, 45: No. 3, 45-9.—Conviction secured for obtaining fraudulent admission to Marine Hospital. Hosp. News, Wash., 1937, 4: No. 10, 38.—Davis. M. M.. jr. The succes of the pay clinic. Mod. Hosp., 1925,25: 201-4.— De Sales. M. F. Front office courtesy. Hospitals, 1937, 11: No. 7. 20-2.—Dillon, H. M. Discharge practices in 58 general and special hospitals. Mod. Hosp., 1938, 51: 49.—Fay, T. What is a ward patient? Bull. Am. M. Ass., 1934, 29: 33-6.— Forbus, S. B. The requisites of an admitting department. Hospitals, 1936, 10: No. 6. 76-9.—Gray, W. J. Admittance procedure at City Hospital. Bull. Acad. M. Cleveland, 1935, lit: No. 7, 7; 12.—Haller, H. G. Personalizing hospitalization. Hospitals 1941, 15: No. 10. 118-22.—Jolly, R. Procedure in admitting and discharging the patient. Tr. Am. Hosp. Ass 1931, 33: 400-9.—Kasper, E. M. Determining hospital eligi- bility requirements for free care. Hospitals, 1936, 10: No. 6, 113-6.—Keusen, H. Zentralisierte Krankenaufnahme: Ja oder Nein? Zschr. ges. Krankenhauswes., 1939, 279-81.— Klotz, W. C. The place of the pay clinic in organized medicine. Tr. Am. Hosp. Ass., 1927, 29: 310-5.—MacCurdy, F. Unified patient admission. Bull. Am. Hosp. Ass., 1931, 5: 32-42.— Middle incomes at Bristol. Lancet, Lond., 1941, 2: 624.— Money, F. M. Discharge arrangements for hospital patients. Hospitals, 1940, 14: No. 1, 103-5.—Morris, I. The admission policies of the Firmin Desloge Hospital. Hosp. Progr., 1933, 14:234.------Admission of patients. Ibid., 1940, 21: 41- 4.—Moss, W. O. Admission policy of the state supported general hospitals. N. Orleans M. & S. J., 1941-42, 94: 355 — Niles. W. L. Pay cUnics. Tr Coll. Physicians Philadelphia, 1922, 44: 65-80—Setz. M. Die Aufnahmebader im Kranken- haus. Zschr. ges. Krankenhauswes., 1937, 119-21.—Sherrick, J. AV. Making room for the acutely ill. Mod. Hosp., 1942, £8: 70.—Treatment of private patients in hospitals. Brit. M. J 1937, 2: Suppl. No. 1716, 2)1.— Ward, H. R. The admission of patients from outpatient department into hospital. J. Ass Am. M. Coll., 1931, 6: 268-77.—Waiting-lists. Lancet, Lond. 1941,1:83.—Wing, F.E. Pay clinics. N. England J. M., 1930, 203: 920-7. Also repr.—Zenger, J. H. The discharge slip Mod. Hosp., 1941, 57: No. 6, 66 ---- Charity service. See also Charity; Group medicine, Hospital service. Clinic abuse. J. Missouri M. Ass., 1935, 32: 203.—Telling, W. H. M. The role of hospital almoners in the maintenance of health and the avoidance of disease. J. State M., Lond., 1933, 41: 21-41.—Washburn, F. A. The humanity of a hospital Tr. Am. Hosp. Ass., 1933, 35: 601-7.— Wilinsky, C. F. What is hospital indigency? Hospitals, 1941, 15: 13-6. ---- Community service. Alvarez, W. C. What a hospital can do for a community Hospitals, 1941, 15: 21-3.—Baker, N. D. The hospital's place in our communities. Tr. Am. Hosp. Ass., 1936, 38: 689-93.__ Benhamou. E. La clinique au service de l'hygiene. Gaz mid France. 1939. 11: Hydr., No. 8. 5-9.—Bierring, W. L. The hospital as a community asset. Bull. Am. Hosp. Ass., 1932, 6: 8-18.—Binfchara, J. J. The hospital's relations with locai agencies. Hosp. Progr., 1940, 21: 33-8.—Black, B. W. The manifold obligations of hospitals to the public. Hospitals, 1937. 11: No. 7. 11-.").—Boudreau. F. G. The preventive role of hospitals. Nosokomeion, Stuttg., 1934, 5: 223-8— Cody. H. J. The contribution wliich a hospital mav make to its community. Tr. Am. Hosp. Ass., 1939, 41: 462-9.—Cook, J. Hospitals and altruism. Brit. M. J., 1942, 1: 12S.—dimming! H. S. The municipal general hospital of the future and its relation to public health. Med. Life, N. Y., 1933, 40: 158 62.— Davis, M. M. The contribution to the community through hospital councils. Tr. Am. Hosp. Ass., 1936, 38: 669-74.— Decker, H. B. Report of the Advisory Committee on Hospital Relationships. J. M. Soc. N. Jersey, 1941, 38: 235.—Kmmerson C. P. The university hospital; its social and economic service to the state. J. Michigan M. Soc, 1926, 25: 55-9.—Gouachon, A. Le role des h6pitaux francais pour le traitement des malades, l'enseignement de la medecine, et le concours apport6 aux autres collectivit£s publiques. Nosokomeion, Stuttg., 1930, 1: 111- 25.—Guldbradsen, B. N. [Intra-communal hospital concerns! Ugeskr. laeger, 1937, 99: 204.—Heath, E. M. How the rural hospital can best serve its community. Hospitals, 1938, 12: No. 5, 62.—Hoehler, F. K. The relation of hospitals to public welfare administration. Tr. Am. Hosp. Ass., 1936, 38: 496- 500.—Jorge, J. M. Hospital moderno, centro de salud. Rev. As. mid. argent., 1941, 55: 312. Also Rev. san. mil., Habana, 1941, 5: 131-5.—MacEachern, M. T. Contribution of hospitals to the community; view of the hospital administrator. Hosp. Progr., 1938, 19: 161-4.—Mountin, J. W. Specific contribu- tions which hospitals can make to public health programs Tr. Am. Hosp. Ass., 1939, 41: 479-88.—Osmena, S. 1937 national hospital day; how hospitals serve the nation. Filip Nurse, 1937, 12: No. 3, 17.—Raymond, S. P. A hospital side line that helps the institution and the public. Mod. Hosp., 1933, 41: 85-7.-—Ronzani, E. L'ordinamento e l'attivitft dell'ospedale nella cura generale della salute in Italia. Noso- komeion, Stuttg., 1932, 3: 15-22.—Rorem, C. R. Hospitals as social capital. Ibid.. 1936, 7: 245-8.—Sefieriz, R. H. The function of the district hospitals in relation to community needs. Bol. As. med. Puerto Rico, 1941, 33: 426-33.—Smith, B. C. The community hospital; what it should be. J. Am. M. Ass., 1939, 112: 1664-7.—Smith, W. H. The hospital, its relation to the community and to the medical profession. Ann. Int. M„ 1931, 5: 212-23.—Snedecor, S. T. Hospital relationships; a supplementary report of the committee on hospital relation- ships given before the house of delegates, June 6, 1939. J. M. Soc. N. Jersey, 1939, 36: 414-23.—Wilinsky, C. F., Jennett, .1. H. |et al.] Report of the Committee on Public Health Relations, 1936. Tr. Am. Hosp. Ass., 1936, 38: 104-10. ---- Consultant service. Baehr, G. A consultation service limited to patients of low income; report after 7 years of operation. Tr. Am. Hosp. Ass., 1939, 41: 796-804.—Bradbury. S. Consultation service from the out-patient department. Ibid., 1933, 35: 561-71 — Hume, E. H. The place of mission hospitals and medical schools in the national health programme of China. Chin. M. J., 1935, 49: 946-50.—Part-time consultants and specialists service. Lancet, Lond., 1933, 1: 711-3. ---- Departmentalization. Carrera. J. L. La carrera medica hospitalaria y la especiali zaci6n; sobre la creaci6n de secciones en los servicios hospits- larios. Prensa mid. argent., 1941, 28: pt 1, 616-8.—Deglmanr., T. Aufgaben und Betrieb interner Krankenhausabteilunger. Deut. med. Wschr., 1941, 67: 268-71.—Fry. L. W. Traverse City links its mental and general hospital. Mod. Hosp., 1926, 27: 79-82.—Krumbhaar. E. B. The relation of the speci-il departments of a hospital to clinical medicine. Bull. An. Coll. Surgeons, 1926, 10: No. 2, 32-5.—Washburn, F. A. Decentralized professional services in large hospitals. Bull. Am. Hosp. Ass., 1931, 5: 32-6. Educational service. Bachmeyer, A. C. The role of the hospital in advanced professional training. Proc. Annual Congr. M. Educ, 1938, 34. Congr., 41-4. Also Fed. Bull., Chic, 1939, 25: 13-20.— Bulman, M. M. Initiating a clinical teaching program. Hosp. Management, 1941, 51: 44-6.—Cleveland. A. J. The working of a private patients' ward; a year's experience in the Norfolk and Norwich Hospital. Brit. M. J., 1929, 1: 1005 — Clinical courses in hospitals |Italy] J. Am. M. Ass., 1939, 113: 1825.—Colwell, N. P. The standard hospital as a training school for better physicians and nurses. Hosp. Progr., 1926, 7: 343-5.—Davis, C. E. The role of the hospital, in the educa- tion of doctors, nurses and other engaged in the care of the sick. Hospitals, 1936, 10: No. 1, 57-9.—Educational work of hos- pitals pointed out at trustees' session. Hosp. Management, 1941, 52: No. 4, 22.—Essay contest for students sponsored by N. Y. hospitals. Ibid , 1940, 50: No. 1, 22.—Evans, L. J. The rural hospital, an educational center. Proc. Annual Congr. M. Educ, 1938, 34. Congr., 38-41. Also J. Am. M. Ass., 1938, 110: 945-8. Also Bol. Of. san. panamer., 1939, 18: 1060-7.—Fisher, G. Mt. Sinai has training course for social service volunteers. In Hosp. Admin. & Org. (Hosp. Manage- ment) Chic, 1942, 128.—Goodale, W. S. The city hospital as a teaching unit of a medical school. Hospitals, 1940, 14: No. 2, 79-SL—Gregg, A. The relationship of hospital to HOSPITAL SERVICE 851 HOSPITAL SERVICE medical school. Harvard M. Alumni Bull., 1939-40, 14: 6-9.—Herrick, J. B. The educational function of a hospital. J. Michigan M. Soc, 1926, 25: 55-9.—Hockett, A. J., Arm- strong, L. M. [et al.] Report of the Committee on Public Education, 1937. Tr. Am. Hosp. Ass., 1937, 39: 181-5 — Kahn, A. A teaching hospital that incorporates new ideas; University of Michigan, Ann Arbor. Mod. Hosp., 1927, 28: No. 5, 63-70.—Ketcham, D. Enrichment through illness. Ibid., 1938, 50: No. 6, 67.—Moore, M. F. Hospitals and hos- pital schools. Crippled Child, 1937-38, 15: 155-8.—Morrison, J. T. The small community hospital as a teaching hospital. J. Am. M. Ass., 1939, 113: 2325. Also J. Maine M. Ass., 1939, 30: 247-53.—Munger, C. W. Possible educational activities in nonteaching public hospitals. Tr. Am. Hosp. Ass., 1932, 34: 320-8.—Overholser, W. The function of the state hospital as an educational and social agency. J. Am. M. Ass., 1942, 118: 1027-30; 119: 216.—Packer, S. A teaching program in the out-patient department. Johns Hopkins Nurs. Alumnae Mag., 1941, 40: 75-80.—Patrick. M. Some aspects of unifying the Catholic hospital with the Catholic college. Hosp. Progr., 1934, 15: 354-6.—Romano, J. Patients' attitudes and be- havior in ward round teaching. J. Am. M. Ass., 1941, 117: 664-7.—Salomon, H. Das Krankenhaus als Unterrichtsstatte. Zschr. ges. Krankenhauswes., 1929, 25: 626-9.—Sister Anna Rita. Educational possibilities of the central supply unit. Mod. Hosp., 1942, 58: 71.—Sister John or the Cross. The community and guidance. Hospitals, 1940, 14: No. 7, 29-31.— Sproat-Martindale, E. College and hospital cooperate in bedside teaching program. Hosp. Management, 1942, 53: 82. ---- Ethics. Agnew, G. H., Bacon, A. S. [et al.] Code of hospital ethics. Hospitals, 1942, 16: 60-3.—Cabot, R. C. Medical ethics in the hospital. Nosokomeion, _ Stuttg., 1931, 2: 151-61.— Court of appeals of New York interprets the law of privileged communications. Hospitals, 1941, 15: 78-80.—Lamare, J. P., & Larget, M. BarSmes d'hospitalisation et secret profession- al. Bull, med., Par., 1938, 52: 427-9.—Lilly. L. Comments on a code of ethics for Catholic hospitals. Hosp. Progr., 1933, 14: 333-5.—MacEachern. M. T. The code of medical ethics as applied to the hospital physician. Bull. Am. Coll. Surgeons, 1933, 17: 33-9. Also Mod. Hosp., 1933, 41: 45-8.—Mechtildis, M. Hospital ethics. Bull. Am. Hosp. Ass., 1935, 9: 54-8.— Moral problems in hospital practice by Roman catholics. Lancet, Lond., 1936, 1: 640.—Privileged communications: privilege applicable only to judicial proceedings, not to legis- lative investigations. J. Am. M. Ass., 1940, 115: 1661. --- Evaluation. Bay, E. B. The quality of care rendered by the University of Chicago clinics. 55p. 8? Chic, 1932. Fidlek, F. G. The patient looks at the hos- pital. 128p. 8? Lond., 1936. Sister John Gabriel. Through the patient's eyes; hospitals, doctors, nurses. 264p. 8? Phila. [1935] Berghoff, R. S. The improvement and development of general melicine in the hospital. Hosp. Progr., 1930, 11: 293-5.—Borst. H. W. An outsider looks at hospitals. Hos- pitals, 1941, 15: No. 3, 45-8.—Bowditch, I. How I, as a trustee, judge the efficiency of our hospital. Bull. Am. Coll. Surgeons, 1935, 19: 83-6.—Bradley, F. The patient and his hospital. Washington Univ. M. Alumni Q., 1941^12, 5: 11-6.—Car- penter, C. C. A better surgical-pathological service in small hospital and private practice. South. M. & S., 1933, 95: 417-9.—Davis. M. M. What the public has a right to expect of cUnics. N. England J. M., 1931, 204: 604-7.—Day. J. W. A patient's view of a hospital. Hospitals, 1940, 14: No. 1, 18-21.—Doane, J. C. What the public thinks of present day hospital practices. Tr. Am. Hosp. Ass., 1931, 33: 684-95 — Fike, O. K. The value of the institutional personality. Ibid., 1939, 41: 327-32. ------ Criticism of hospitals not justified. Hosp. Management, 1941, 52: No. 4, 8; 77—Goodale, W. S. The patient; some of his reactions to hospital administration. J. Am. M. Ass., 1930, 94: 906-9.—Griffin. M. F. The challenge to hospitals in the changing attitude toward them. Ibid., 1941, 116: 1720.—Groves, E. W. H. Some remarks on our present hospital system. Brit. M. J., 1927, 2: 131-4.—Holme, P. H. A layman looks at hospitals. Rocky Mountain M. J., 1939, 36: 100-2.—Josephson, E. M. Hospital and clinic rackets. In his Merchants in Med., N. Y., 1941, 125-36 — Lamb, S. An EngUsh hospital executive's impression of America; American hospitals seen through the eyes of a promi- nent EngUsh hospital executive. Hosp. Management, 1935, 39: No. 3, 16-9.—Langenskiold, F. [Impressions from Ameri- can hospitals] Fin. lak. sail, hand., 1930. 72: 315-25.— Lewinski-Corwin, E. H. Can hospital productivity be meas- ured? Tr. Am. Hosp. Ass., 1927, 29: 264-9—Littman, A. Psychological motives of aversion towards the hospital; from observation and impression of a ward-patient. Hospitals, 1936, 10: No. 8, 61-7.—May, B. Do hospitals give patients good value for their money? N. York Physician^ 1935, 5: 19.— Moore, S. E. Canadian hospital efficiency. Canad. M. Ass. J., 1927, 17: 567-70.—Ortega Belgrano, R. El por que de la existencia de la falta de atencion hospitalaria. Prensa mid argent., 1939, 26: pt 1, 383—Parlett, S. A patient's lament. Mod. Hosp., 1938, 50: No. 2, 49.—Sundberg, C. G. [Report on a visit of American hospitals] Sven. lak. tidn., 1929, 26: 732; 765.—What the public is thinking. West. Hosp. Rev . 1933-34,21:12. ---- Geography. Brasil. Assistencia Hospitalar. Con- ferencias proferidas durante a semana do hos- pital (de 26 a 31 de Marco de 1928) 109p. 8? Rio, 1929. Abt, I. A., Capps, J. A. [et al.] Medical services in Cook County Hospital. Proc Inst. M. Chicago, 1938-39, 12: 345-7.—Acufia, P. S. Los servicios hospitalarios y las dona- ciones. In his Un rimero d. verd., 2. ed., B. Air., 1938, 150-2.— Allaire, M. V. Hospital work and home nursing in the Far North. Hosp. Progr., 1933, 14: 447-50.—Bonnell, R. O. First year of associated hospital service of Baltimore. Hos- pitals, 1939, 13: No. 2, 94-8.—Complete service planned by St. Joseph's Infirmary. Hosp. Management, 1926, 21: No. 4, 46-8.—Davies, W. R. Comparative digest of general hospital practice; Scranton area; 1926-37. Med. Soc. Rep., Scranton, 1939, 33: No. 3, 12.—Deganello, U. SuU'assistenza ospitaliera in Italia e in altri stati con speciale riguardo a Roma e ad alcune grandi citti dell'estero. Arch. sc. osp., 1911, 1: 89; 121.—Domonkos, A. [American hospitals! Orv. hetil., 1937, 81: 1297.—Dublin hospitals affording recognised practice. Lancet, Lond., 1938, 2: 503-5.—Frankel, E. Trends in general hospital services in New Jersey, 1929-37. Hospitals, 1939, 13: 30-4.—Giuffrida, G. I moderni concetti dell'assistenza ospedaUera. Osp. maggiore Novara, 1938, 15: 448-63.— Goldwater, S. S. New York City has a plan for low cost ward service. Mod. Hosp., 1941, 56: No. 4, 67.—Gottlieb, J. Bing- ham hospital extension services. J. Maine M. Ass., 1940, 31: 155-8.—Hill, C. Britain plans a national hospital service. Hospitals, 1942, 16: No. 2, 93.—Hockett, A. J. Touro in- firmary serves all, regardless of race or creed. Hosp. Manage- ment, 1939, 47: No. 3, 27-9.—Hospitals affording recognised practice. Lancet, Lond., 1935, 2: 506-9.—Hospital service in Buenos Aires. J. Am. M. Ass., 1941, 116: 2097.—Hospital service in Iowa; a report of progress. J. Iowa M. Soc, 1941, 31: 213-6.—Hospital service in the United States. J. Am. M. Ass., 1936, 106: 783-97; 1937, 108: 1035-48.—Hospital service in the United States; 21st annual presentation of hospital data by the Council on Medical Education and Hospitals of the American Medical Association. Ibid., 1942, 118: 1053-142.— Knottenbelt, C. P. Hospitals in Holland. Canad. Nurse, 1932, 29: 68-72.—Lutrario, A. Quelques remarques sur l'assistance hospitalise en Italie. Bull. Off. internat. hyg. pub., Par., 1934, 26: 501-20.—Mendes de Castro. O hospital das clinicas. Gaz. clin., S. Paulo, 1940, 38: 127. iU.—Miihsam, R. Wissenschaftliche Leistungen deutscher Krankenhauser. Med. Welt, 1932, 6: 926-8.—Muniz Angulo, L. Algunos aspectos interesantes de los hospitales americanos y canadienses. Rev. san. mil., Habana. 1940, 4: 14478— Olson, G. W. The hospitals of Sweden Uve up to their just fame; excellent dis- cipline, incredible cleanliness, fine equipment, adjusted methods of payment mark Europe's finest hospitals. Hosp. Manage- ment, 1935, 39: No. 2, 28-30.—Peep (A) into Indian hospital life. Nurs. Times, Lond., 1936, 32: 316-8.—Ponton. T. R. Oregon's hospital service analyzed. Hosp. Management, 1940, 50: No. 2, 13-5.—Schuck, W. P. South America mod- ernizing its poUcy for hospital care. Ibid., 49: No. 6, 15.— Sloan, R. P. Beekman street answers call of downtown New York. Mod. Hosp., 1934, 43: 40-4.—Van Steenwyk, E. A. The American hospital steps ahead. Rocky Mountain M. J., 1938, 35: 47-52.—Vietzke, P. C. F. White man's medicine. Mod. Hosp., 1939, 53: No. 1, 71-5. ---- governmental. Crain, K. C. Brands federal hospitaUzation program as ill-advised. Ho.sp. Management, 1942, 53: No. 3, 16.— Davis, M. M., & Plumley, M. Governmental hospitals; im- portance in general care. Mod. Hosp., 1939, 53: No. 1, 76-8.— Goldwater, S. S. Co-operation between voluntary and govern- mental or tax-supported hospitals. Bull. Am. Coll. Surgeons, 1939, 24: 179.—Government competition with the private practice of medicine and private hospitals. J. M. Ass. Georgia, 1932, 21: 377.—Hertzog, L. C. The Taft plan. J. Am. Inst. Homeop., 1940, 33: 289-91.—Morrison, A. The place of municipal clinics in a medical service. Pub. Health, Lond., 1942 55: 116-21.—Oppenheimer, R. H. Politics and the public hospital. Tr. Am. Hosp. Ass., 1936, 38: 809-19 — Packard, L. A. Pay patients not eligible to care in Kern County Hospital; competition of county hospitals with private institutions unlawful, rules superior Judge K. Van Zante. West. Hosp. Rev., 1933, 21: 7.—Schuize, H. Verbesserung der pflegerischen Versorgung der Kranken in den stadtischen Krankenhiiusern der Reichshauptstadt. Zschr. ges. Kranken- hauswes 1937, 333-7.—Shall the politicians control our hos- pitals? North Carolina M. J., 1942, 3: 108.—Stonebanks, E. H. L. A state hospital service. Med. Off., Lond., 1935, 54: gfj_8.—Van Zante, K. PubUc hospitals in California cannot HOSPITAL SERVICE 852 HOSPITAL SERVICE hospitalize non-indigent patients. California West. M., 1936, 44: 1S9-92.- Will, A. J. Relationship between public and private hospitals in California. Hospitals, 1938, 12: No. 4, 94-6. ---- Medical service. American Medical Association. Council on Medical Education. Hospital practice for interns. 112p. S? [Chic, 1932] Asheville, N. C. Highland Hospital, Inc. How Highland Hospital helps. 24p. 15cm. Asheville, X. C. [1939] Calder, R. M., & Gardner, C. E. Essentials of hospital practice; a guide for students and internes, with a section on surgical methods. 262p. 8? Durham, N. C., 1934. Preston, A. D. At the surgeon's mercy. 42p. 8? [Beckley, W. Va,] 1927. Acuiia, P. S. Un complemento de la reglamentaci6n sobre asistencia. hospitalaria en la provincia de Buenos Aires, que tlebe .ser conoeido. Sem. mid., B. Air., 1940, 47: pt 2, 1081.— American Hospital Association establishes principles for medical service. J. Am. M. Ass., 1938, 111: 1470.—Angel Ugarte, L. El hospital centro de trabajo medico. Rev. mid. peru., 1941, 13: 475-9. Bartlett. E. I. The relation of the clinical pathologist to the medical staff in maintaining the scientific efficiency of the hospital. Proc. Panpacific Surg. Conf., 1929, 1. Conf., 223-5.—Bergstrand, A. [Cooperation between physicians of closed and open medical care of the sick] Sven. lak. tidn., 1935, 32: 691-9.—Carr, J. G. The adequate care of patients from standpoint of the medical staff. Hos- pitals, 1936, 10: No. 6, 12.—Flesch, J. Zusammenarbeit von KUnik und Hausarzt. Miinch. med. Wschr., 1937, 84: 604.— Golub, J. J. Coordinating ihe efforts of hospital and physician. Mod. Ho>p., 1935, 45: No. 2, 73.—Guinon, L. Deux ans de prophvl i\ie et d'antisepsie medieale dans un service de l'hopi- tal Tn.usseau. Bull. Soe. med. hop. Paris, 1903, 3. ser., 20: 849-51.- Hellinga, G. [Regulation of medical care in St. Peters Hospital in Amsterdam 1 Ned. tschr. geneesk., 1939, 83: 514-22.-—Hinenburg, M. Serving the patient; a check list. In Hosp. Yearb., 1941, 19: 920-3.—Irons, E. E. Selection of proprietary versus nonproprietary drugs in hospital prescrib- ing. J. Am. M. Ass\, 1930, 94: 1277-9.—Johnson, L. Coopera- tion of the hospital with the family doctor. Bull. Am. Hosp. Ass., 1934, 8: No, 9, 89.—Johnson, P. P. The contribution of the community hospital to better medical service. Tr. N. England Surg. Soc, 1935, 18: 18-29. Also N. England J. M., 1936, 214: 295-8.—Jorge, J. M. Asistencia m6dica hos- pitalaria. Dia mid., B. Air., 1938. 10: 409-11— Kiaer. R., & Fenger, M. [Observations of the Board of Directors and the majority and minority opinions of the committee on the pro- posed investigation of the practice of hospital physicians with the aid of assistants] Ugeskr. laeger, 1941, 103: 273-7.— Knapp, M. N. Professional service in the small hospital. Hosp. Management, 1938, 45: 25.—Korteweg, A. J. [Observa- tions on the post mortem service in small hospitals] Zieken- huis, 1927, 18: 78-80.— Lewis, D. The place of the clinic in medical practice. J. Am. M. Ass., 1933, 100: 1905-10. Also repr.—Lovejoy, E. P. American Women's hospitals (Medical Service Committee) Q. BuU. M. Women's Nat. Ass., 1934, No. 46, 19.—MacCurdy, F. What 337,102 visits taught us about clinic management. Hosp. Management, 1930, 30: 21-4.—New York's medical and ward care service. Minne- sota M., 1941, 24: 679.—Ponton, T. R. Professional practices. Bull. Am. Coll. Surgeons, 1939, 24: 224.—Riesman, D. The organization of the medical clinic. Ibid., 1926, 10: No. 2, 21-6.—Rietz, T. [Cooperation between physicians of closed and open medical care of the sick] Sven. lak. tidn., 1935, 32: 718-22.—Konne, H. [Hospitals and practical medical work] Ugeskr. laeger, 1937, 99: 1239-45.—Royster, H. A. The hospital manner. Diplomate, Phila., 1934. 6: 265-7.—Schitten- helm, A. Ueber die Aufgaben der inneren Klinik. Hippo- krates, Stuttg., 1939, 10: 1305-11.—Schwitalla, A. M. The medical staff's responsibility for hospital routine. Bull. Am. ColL Surgeons, 1930, 14: 31-4.—Spelman. J. D. What is the ideal organization of the medical staff in order to promote efficiency of the professional work of the hospital? Tr. Am. Hosp. Ass., 1928, 30: 323-8.—Turner, J. Create no privileged class. Mod. Hosp., 1937, 49: No. 3, 53.—What constitutes adequate scientific study of a patient? Ibid., 1933, 40: 102-5.— Wilbur, R. L. The fundamental place of the hospital in the practice of medicine. Bull. Am. M. Ass., 1932, 27: 28 31 Also Proc. Congr. M. Educ., 1932, 1.—Zapffe, F. C. Medical service in CathoUc hospitals. Hosp. Progr., 1941, 22: 190-4. ---- Night and holiday service. Arrangements for the night in 30 institutions surveyed. Mod. Hosp., 1942, 58: No. 3, 80.—Sibley, C. L. Business practices of smaU hospitals on nights, Sundays, holidays. Tr. Am. Hosp. Ass., 1937, 39: 198-503. ---- Nursing service. Amadeo, M. Achievements of sisterhoods in nursing-care activities. Hosp. Progr., 1941, 22: 188-90.—Andrews, B. What is the small hospital to do? Canad. Nurse, 1941, 37: 751.—Anscombe, E. M. Methods of ascertaining the value of student services. Tr. Am. Hosp. Ass., 1937, 39: 631-H. - Augusta, M. Practical methods of rotating nurses in clinical services. Hosp. Progr., 1934, 15: 24-9.— Hlake. E.. jr. Gradu- ate nursing in the modern hospital. Hospitals. 1936. 10: No. 6, 65.—Brandt, A. Die Krankenpflege und ihre Ixjistungen im Rahmen der neuen Aufgaben des Krankenhauses. Nosoko- meion, Stuttg., 1934, 5: 35-9.—Burgess. M. A. The hospital and the nursing supply. Tr. Am. Hosp. Ass., 1927, 29: 400- 15.—Carter, F. G. Hospital and nursing problems. Hospitals, 1941, 15: No. 5, 25-7.—Densford, K. J. Securing quantity and quality of nursing service. Ibid., 1939, 13: No. 6, 17-20.— Dock, L. L. The development of nursing in hospitals. Noso- komeion, Stuttg., 1931, 2: 26.5-75.—Dubin, M. Thirty-hour week will mean shortage of nurses; old man budget dictates policies of many hospitals, says writer, who suggests value of definite minimum standards. Hosp. Management, 1933, 35: 23.—Ewing, N. H. Sources of errors in hospital nursing prac- tice. Hospitals, 1939, 13:20-3.—Farrand, E. M. Performance of cUnical procedures by nurses in large hospitals. Ibid., 1941, 15: No. 11, 25.—Geister, J. M. More about general duty. Trained Nurse, 1941, 107: 346-8.—Gordon, P. Nursing costs; a studv made at the Charles T. Miller Hospital, St Paul, Minnesota. Am. J. Nurs., 1930. 30: 1495-8.—Graves, F. J. How Alton Memorial Hospital plans early morning care. Hosp. Management, 1941, 52: No. 5, 56.—Greener. E. A. The hospital is no stronger than its nursing service. Mod. Hosp., 1933, 41: 55-9.—Hall, G. M. Nursing service in small hospitals Canad. Nurse, 1942, 38: 23-5.—Hatfield. J. N. Newer con- cepts. Hospitals, 1940, 14: No. 7, 59-62.—Hospital nursing service with a graduate staff. West. Hosp. Rev., 1935-36, 23: No. 7, 7.—Kandel, P. M. Graduate nurses to supplement student service. Tr. Am. Hosp. Ass., 1931, 32: 727-37.— Kaplan, R. H. Adequate nursing service. Hospitals, 1938, 12: No. 3, 45-7. ------ Nursing service for the small hospital. Ibid., 1940, 14: No. 4, 85.—Kelly, L. E. Graduate nursing in rural hospitals. Am. J. Nurs., 1932, 32: 960; 1140.—McHugh, M. B. Relationship of housekeeping and nursing service at University of Minnesota Hospitals. Hosp. Management, 1941, 52: No. 4, 64.—MacLachlan. M. J. Guide to good nursing; for the smaller sized hospital. Mod. Hosp., 1941, 56: No. 3, 61.—McNee, J. Group nursing from the point of view of the administrator. Tr. Am. Hosp. Ass., 1927, 29: 393.— Maroney. K. A. How a small hospital can nurse its patients without a school. Am. J. Nurs., 1932, 32: 640-2.—Mother M. Concordia. Keeping efficient nursing care of the sick in the foreground of our thinking; a guiding principle for the adminis- trators of our Catholic hospitals and our Catholic schools of nursing. Hosp. Progr., 1940, 21: 268-73.-—Nursing in small hospitals in small towns. Am. J. Nurs., 1940, 40: 1370-2.— Pfefferkorn, B. Let us look at our cUnical services. Ibid., 1935, 35: 162-9. ------ Cost study of nursing service and nursing education. Tr. Am. Hosp. Ass., 1938, 40: 657-61.— Philomena, M. Effcient nursing service in a small hospital. Hospitals, 1939, 13: No. 5, 97.—Price, A. L. Prelude to duty; interpreting the rhythm of ward service. Trained Nurse, 1940, 105: 379-82.—Rockwood, H. L. Meeting the standards of good nursing care; the hospital with a small school and large graduate staff. Hospitals, 1936, 10: 96.—Rogers, IL Team- work within the hospital. Am. J. Nurs., 1932, 32: 657-9.— Itovetta, C. A. Cost study of nursing service and nursing edu- cation. Tr. Am. Hosp. Ass., 1938. 40: 661-8.—Scheidt, A. II. A practical method of making time studies of nursing activities in the hospital. Hosp. Management, 1939, 48: No. 5, 35-40.— Schonfeldt. M. Welche Anforderungen sind vom Standpunkt einwandfreier Krankenpflege an das Pflegepersonal in den Krankenhausern zu stellen und wie ist—auch im Hinblick auf laut gewordene Beschwerden iiber ungebiihrUche Ausnutzung des Pflegepersonals—der Krankenpflegedienst in den Kranken- anstalten zu regeln? Zschr. Krankenpfl., 1920, 42: 291-304 — Scott. A. H. Status of graduate nurse service as indicated by recent studies conducted through the American Nurses' Asso- ciation Headquarters. Tr. Am. Hosp. Ass., 1938, 40: 410-7.— Sister Alice Regina. Nursing service to the Nation. Hosp. Progr., 1941, 22: 194-7.—Sister Antonia. Nursing problems and their solution. Tr. Am. Hosp. Ass., 1938, 40: 392-400 — Sister M. Patricia. The general duty nurse in the care of the sick. Ibid., 1939, 41: 518-23.—Spaulding, G. E. Nursing in the small community hospital. Am. J. Nurs., 1941, 41: 1033- 5.—Taylor, E. The organization and function of the nursing department in a 300 bed hospital. Nurs. J. China, 1936, Jan. 13-9. ------ Present trends in nursing as affecting nursing education and nursing service in hospitals. Hosp. Manage- ment, 1938, 46: No. 5, 31-4. Also Bull. Am. Coll. Surgeons, 1939, 24: 180.—Teal, H. In a small hospital nursing is not simple. Mod. Hosp., 1935, 45: No. 1, 57-9.—Titus, S. C. The present position of nursing in hospitals in the United States. Nosokomeion, Stuttg., 1931, 2: 288-314.—Torrop, H. M. How much nursing service should an orderly give? Am. J. Nurs., 1937, 37: 15-7.—Van de Vrede, J. The hospital's responsibility for nursing. Bull. Am. Hosp. Ass., 1932, 6: 33.—Vonder Heidt, L. C. Group nursing as a means toward the reduction of the cost of iUness. Tr. Am. Hosp. Ass., 1931, 32: 204-14.-—Warman, G. A. Practices and evaluation of a present day hospital nursing service. Bull. Am. Coll. Surgeons, 1939, 24: 229.—Wetzel, S. M. What's wrong with the nursing in our hospitals? Trained Nurse, 1936, 97: 244-7.—Wolf, L. K. Development of floor nursing and supervision. Hospitals, HOSPITAL SERVICE 853 HOSPITAL SERVICE 1941, 15: No. 3, 53-6.—Yager, M. E. Co-ordination; nursing; education; administration. Tr. Am. Hosp. Ass., 1928, 30: 224-6. ---- Organization. Altmeyer, A. J. The relationship of hospital service to a national health program. Tr. Am. Hosp. Ass., 1938, 40: 215- 24.—Alvaro, M. E. Pequeno ensaio sobre a racionalizacao dos services cUnicos. Rev. otoneur., B. Air., 1931, 6: 187-9. ------ A organizacao scientifica do trabalho nos hospitaes Mem. Congr. med. (Brazil) 1936, 1. Congr., 311-7.—Atkins, J. B., Birks, W. G. [et al.] Postwar hospital services. Lancet Lond., 1941, 1: 706.—Bishop, R. H., jr. The hospital in the hospital service plan. Hospitals, 1941, 15: No. 6, 21-3.— Borden, R. P. Look ere thou leap, see ere thou go (Thomas Tusser 1557) Ibid., 1940, 14: No. 10, 29-31.—Buzzard, F. Future trends in the hospital world. Nurs. Times, Lond., 1941 37: 982.—Clark, R. V., & Bedwell. C. E. A. Discussion on the future of the general hospital. J. R. San. Inst., 1938-39, 59: 198-210.—Decker, C. J. Protection for workers; Ontario Hospital Association launches plan for hospital care designed to safeguard workers against worries of hospital bills. Health, Toronto, 1941, 9: 14.—Ellis, W. J. How shall the hospital develop to meet the demands of the future? Tr. Am. Hosp. Ass., 1937, 39: 531-42.—Fitz, F. What the hospital service plan means to the physician. Hospitals, 1941, 15: No. 6, 96.— Fitzwilliams, D. C. L. The hospital of the future. Brit. M. J 1934, 1: 382-4.—Ginsburg. H. M. Fresno County [California] Hospital plan for low income group. Hospitals, 1941, 15: No. 6, 61-3.—Grant, J. Hospital services from the administrative point of view. J. R. San. Inst., 1939-40, 60: 1-10.—Hospital reform. Med. Off., Lond., 1941, 66: 26.—Hospital service plan news. Hospitals, 1941, 15: No. 6, 92-5.—Hunter, A., Perry, K. M. A.. & Vaizey, J. M. Postwar hospital services. Lancet, Lond., 1941, 1: 639.—Kohl, M. F. Social service for the aged. Mod. Hosp., 1940, 55: 65.—Lewinski-Corwin, E. H. The hospital of the future. Tr. Am. Hosp. Ass., 1938, 40: 209-15.— Lippincott, L. S. Maintaining adequate services in approved hospitals. Hospitals, 1938, 12: No. 3, 43-5.—Luria, P. A. [Organization of the Soviet clinics for internal diseases| Sovet. klin., 1934, 20: 3-14.—MacLean, B. C. The organization of the hospital. In Hosp. Yearb., 1941, 19: 912-9. ------ Rorem. C. R. [et al.] Committee on Hospital Service, annual report 1938. Tr. Am. Hosp. Ass., 1938, 40: 115-22.—Mira y Lopez. E. Psico-tecnia hospitalaria. Rev. mid., B. Air., 1940, 2: 530-7.— Ohio group secures pubUc confidence through planned program of service. Hosp. Management, 1941, 51: No. 5, 22.—Orde, R. H. P. The future development of the hospital system. Brit. M. J., 1938, 2: suppl., 152.—Oseroff, A. Building sound enroll- ment for hospital service plans. Hospitals, 1941, 15: No. 9, 85-8.—Pearson, L. G. The hospital of the future. J. R. San. Inst., 1935-36, 56: 148-52.—Picken, R. M. F. The co-ordina- tion of general hospital services and the provision of additional accommodation. Ibid., 1936, 57: 39-56.—Postwar hospital planning. J. Am. M. Ass., 1941, 117: 2266.—Postwar hospital services. Lancet, Lond., 1941, 1: 772.—Post-war reorganiza- tion of hospitals. Brit. M. J., 1941, 2: 821.—Rorem, C. R. Nurses and hospital service plans. Am. J. Nurs., 1941, 41: 783-6.—Rossi, E. La piu pratica disposizione della Zona dei degenza e della Zona dei servizi complementari per offrire il migliore servizio agU ammalati. Nosokomeion, Stuttg., 1935, B: 59-68.—Routley. F. W. Hospital needs of to-dav. Canad. M. Ass. J., 1932, 26: 186-9.—Schwitalla, A. M. The Presi- dent's address. Hosp. Progr., 1941, 22: 197-208.—Service plans urged to recognize characteristics of Catholic hospitals. Hosp. Management, 1941, 52: 19.—Sewers, R. J., & Bing, N. Results of plan designed to promote cooperation between private practice and clinic service. J. Med., Cincin., 1937-38, 18: 179-82.—Sexton, L. A. The old versus the new in hospitals. Tr. Am. Hosp. Ass., 1933, 35: 264-7.—Sorg, H. T. Hospitals and hospital service plans. Hospitals, 1941, 15: No. 8, 47-9.— Souttar, H. S. Our future hospitals. Brit. M. J., 1929, 2: suppl., 213.—Stewart. S. Discussion of Dr Samuel Proger's paper on hospital extension service. Hospitals, 1939, 13: No. 4, 77.—Tilden, R. [et al.] Abington Hospital broadens its service to humanity. Mod. Hosp., 1929, 32: No. 4, 52-8.—Van Norman, K. H. Both acute and chronic patients cared for in King County hospitals. Hosp. Management, 1939, 47: No. 6. 25-7.—Walter, F. J. Innovations in hospital service conducive to efficiency and economy. Bull. Am. Coll. Surgeons, 1935, 19: 73-6.—Ward, P. D. Hospital service plans and medical prac- tice. Ibid., 1941, 26: 172.—Washburn, F. A. The broadened concept of hospital functions since the year 1896. Hospitals, 1940, 15: No. II, 13-7. ---- Out-patient service. Hardy, H. N. Hospital out-patient reform. 8p. 8? Lond., 1872. Agnew. G. H. Diagnostic clinics. Mod. Hosp., 1938, 50: No. 5, 73.—Amberg, R. M. Periodic review of economic and social status of all out-patients. Hospitals, 1941, 15: No. 12, 39-41.—Binner, M. W. This out-patient department is out- growth of careful planning. Mod. Hosp., 1941, 57: No. 3, 56-9, illust., plans.—Bishop, H. E. Diagnostic clinics; in- patient and out-patient. Tr. Am. Hosp. Ass., 1939, 41: 678- 82.—Bradbury, S. Criteria of adequate medical service in the out-patient department. Ibid., 1931, 32: 692-701. Also Bull. Am. Hosp Ass., 1931, 5: 23-31.-Buerki, R. C. Should all free clinics and dispensaries be integral parts of the hospital? Tr. J B Method- 19f'^.l: 705-7.-Burwell, C. S., & Youmans ™tL* h. &nd °bJectlve? '" the organization of the out- Pol toqfP^T^ °f£ tewbinB hospital. J. Ass. Am. M. Coll., 1935 10: 65-9.—Cabot, H. The changing position of the =^Pf^lentidepart?len^ in.the Rcheme of hospital and medical ri«£ n"? °5T.nt-. ^r' Am-Hosp. Ass., 1927, 29: 297-302.- Uark.D A.,&Clark K. G. Out-patient management. Mod. S°vPi' s? >;,6:*^°' 2,'3-C,inic service in "ban areas, 1940. Social Statist.. Alb.. 1940-41, 4: Suppl. No. 2, 12-8.—Crane, i.. I. What factors should determine the need and size of an ?oQQPa0LenLleTceJn the community? Tr. Am. Hosp. Ass., i.366, 35: 555-8— Defense program shows need for increasing out-patient services. Hosp. Management, 1941, 52: No 4 21; 70—Doane, J. C. Helpful ideas and how to run the out- patient department. Mod. Hosp., 1930, 35: 101-5—Felder- man, L. Lost patients from an outpatient clinic, j. Am. M Ass 1939 113: 2257.—Fleming. I. M. The birth of a clinic. Pub. Health News, Trenton, 1941, 25: 307.—Frankel, E. Statistical analysis of 6.600 out-patients. Hospitals, 1941 15: No 9, 89-97.—Gray, H., & Curtis. M. Lost patients from an outpatient clinic; a study in cooperativeness of patients. J Am. M. Ass., 1939,113: 1037.—Gutierrez, A. La polemica sugli istituti clinici. Italia san., 1910, 6: 309.—Harvey, C. C. Walter Reed Hospital provides extensive out-patient services Hosp. Management, 1941, 52: No. 2, 23.—Hockett, A. J. How should the expanded out-patient department be adminis- tered and financed? Tr. Am. Hosp. Ass., 1939, 41: 723-8 Also Hospitals, 1940, 14: No. 4, 106-8.—Houser, G. F. Clini- cal-administrative relationships in the out-patient department. Ibid., 1939, 13: 49-52.—Howarth, W. The organization of out-patients at a teaching hospital. Brit. M. J., 1939, 1: 991.— Howland, J. B., & Clay, C. L. The out-patient department. Bull. Am. Hosp. Ass., 1929, 3: 179-88.—In out-patients again, as the patient sees it. Nurs. Times, Lond., 1936, 32: 452.— Innes, L. M. Some out-patient treatments. Ibid., 1941, 37: 437; passim.—Introduction (The) into the out-patient depart- ment of the hospital of an appointment system for patients. Guy's Hosp. Gaz., Lond., 1941, 55: 233.—Jarrett. L. E., & Baskervill. H. C. The out-patient department; an important factor in hospital service. Hospitals, 1937, 11: No. 6, 28-32.— Kaiser, B. Selective economic basis for out-patient service. Bull. Am. Coll. Surgeons, 1929, 13: 23-9.—Knowlton, J. G. W. The Out-patient Departments of the Massachusetts General and the Boston City Hospitals. Q. Harvard M. Alumni Ass., 1901-4, 723-40, illust., plan.— Krasniansky, M. [Results of year's work of night sanatarium] Vrach. gaz., 1927, 31: 695- 8.—Langstroth, L. A critical analysis of outpatient work from the point of view of efficiency. J. Am. M. Ass., 1916, 67: 91-4. Also repr.—Lawrence, J. V. Inter-relationship of out- patient and hospital service as regards physicians and patients. Tr. Am. Hosp. Ass., 1938, 40: 364-71. Also Hospitals, 1938, 12: No. 12, 30-4.—Lieberman, I. [On observations of ambu- latory polyclinic organizations] Profil. med., Kharkov, 1927, 6: No. 12, 111-30.—Lyons, A. M. Appointments for hospital outpatients. Lancet, Lond., 1939, 2: 3 52.—MacCurdy, F. Does your hospital need an out-patient department? if so, why? Tr. Am. Hosp. Ass., 1933, 35: 550-4.------Our out-patient department. Bull. Am. Hosp. Ass., 1934, 8: No. 9, 27-32. ------Amberg. R. [et al.] Report of the Out-patient Com- mittee, 1936. Tr. Am. Hosp. Ass., 1936, 38: 80; 1937, 39: 147- 53.—MacCurdy, F. J. The future significance of out-patient care in the country's hospital and medical program. Ibid., 1937, 39: 460-7. Also Hospitals, 1937, 11: No. 11, 46-9.—MacNevin, M. G. The out-patient department, Southern Pacific General Hospital. Pacific Coast M., 1937, 4: 21-4.—Middleton, M. A. Out-patient problems changing with economic conditions; valuable comments and experiences related in this paper on activities of department of Methodist Hospital, Philadelphia. Hosp. Management, 1934, 38: 34-6.—Miller, J. R. The educational and economic value of an out-patient department to a general hospital. Bull. Am. Coll. Surgeons, 1929, 13:. 30-2.—Miller, T. G. The care of the hospital outpatient. N. England J. M., 1941, 224: 1043-9.—Mulroy, J. R. Out- patient clinic in Denver. Mod. Hosp., 1938, 51: No. 2, 62-4 — Nixon, W. C. W. Food advice for the waiting out-patient. Brit. M. J., 1941, 2: 633. Also Lancet, Lond., 1941, 2: 545 — Nye, R. B. Home service from the out-patient department; medical, nursing, social, relief. Tr. Am. Hosp. Ass., 1933, 35: 558-61.—Olsen, E. T. Adequate space and facilities needed for modern out-patient departments. In Hosp. Admin. & Org. (Hosp. Management) Chic, 1942, 27-30.—Parkes, W. The out-patient department. Bull. Am. Hosp. Ass., 1932, 6: 29-39.—Parnall, C. G. Out-patient department in the general hospital. Hospitals, 1938, 12: 55-8.—Plumley, M. L. General out-patient departments the important element in organized out-patient care. Ibid., 1937, 11: No. 9, 30-2. ------ How clinic visits are distributed. Mod. Hosp., 1938, 50: 76-8.— Potter, E. C. Out-patient care for the needy. Hospitals, 1941, 15: No. 4, 69; No. 5, 74.------Bingham, J. J. [et al.) Out- patient care for the needy. Ibid., 1942, 16: No. 3, 89; passim- Problem (The) of the out-patient. Brit. M. J., 1936, 1: Suppl., 118-21 —Ransom, J. E. Some essentials of good out-patient service. Bull. Am. Hosp. Ass., 1929. 3: 203-10. ------ Six considerations in organizing an out-patient department. Mod. Hosp 1934 42:72-4.—Report of the Committee on out-patient work"for 1927. Tr. Am. Hosp. Ass., 1927, 29: 285-96.— Ropchan. A. A picture of clinic service in Chicago. Mod. HOSPITAL SERVICE 854 HOSPITAL SERVICE Hosp., 1936, 46: No. 3, 52.—Smith, F. C. Treating the dispensary patient. Med. World. 1931, 52: 491.—Smith, S. W. Out-patient hospital policy. Brit. M. J., 1942, 1: Suppl., 11.—Upham, J. H. J. Th outpatient clinic. J. Am. M. Ass., 1934, 102: 980-2.—Van L'ttcn. N. B. The relation of hospital out-patient service to the general medical practice of the community; from the point of view of the general practi- tioner. Bull. Am. Hosp. Ass., 1935, 9: 19-22—Wessols. G. L. Out-patient department; its problems. Hospitals, 1941, 15: No 8, 92.—Wing, F. E. Administration of the out-patient department. Bull. Am. Hosp. Ass., 1930, 4: No. 1, 14-9. ------ Medical care of the sick in their homes. Ibid., 1935, 9: 25-33. ------ Diagnostic clinics; in-patient and out- patient. Tr. Am. Hosp. Ass., 1939, 41: 671-8. ---- Principles. Atkinson, M. The patient comes first. p.157-64. 24>^cm. Clipping from: Atlantic Monthly, August 1941, v.168. No. 2. Alter, K. J. The great social encyclicals as applied to hos- pitals. Hosp. Progr., 1940, 21: 239-41.—Goldwater, S. S. the fundamentals of hospital service. In Hosp. Yearb., 1941, 19: 903-11.—Rathbun, N. P. The organization, functions and respondbilities of the modern hospital. Brooklyn Hosp. J., 1939. 1: 67. ---- Radio entertainment. Geuter. Zentral-Rundfunkanlagen fur Krankenhauser und Sanatorien. Zschr. ges. Krankenhauswes., 1929, 25: 94-6.— Kriegesmann, L. Rundfunk in Krankenhausern. Ibid., 1926, 22: 792.—Kuhlmann. Erfahrungen mit Rundfunkdarbietungen im Krankenhaus. Ibid., 793-5.—Noack, F. Rundfunk in Krankenhausern. Ibid., 1928, 24: 161-3.—Pirisch. Rundfunk im Krankenhaus. Ibid., 1926, 22: 178.— Rekas, M. La radio k l'hopital. Nosokomeion, Stuttg., 1938, 9: 146-54.—Sachs. Zur Rundfunkfrage in Krankenhausern und Heilstatten. Zschr. ges. Krankenhauswes., 1927, 23: 723.—Stacey, J. M. Radio, ambassador of good wiU. Mod. Hosp., 1941, 57: No. 6, 76. ---- Recreational facilities. Abelman. M. Modern faculties for traditional ceremony. Hospitals, 1939, 13: No. 2, 92.—Do your Christmas planning now. Mod. Hosp., 1941, 57: No. 6, 84.—Federn, P. Weariness of life in hospital patients. Ment. Hyg., Alb., 1932, 16: 636.— How St Nicholas came to Bergen Pines. Hospitals, 1939, 13: No. 2, 85.—Jacovacci, C. Nuove direttive dcll'arredamcnto di ospedali e sanatori con impianti difTusori di radioaudizione e musica. Atti Congr. internaz. teen, san., 1931, 2. Congr., 2: 61-4.—Nicholas, B. M. Bird-watching in hospital. Nurs. Times, Lond., 1940, 36: 1330. ---- Religious service. Bingham, J. J. The hospital's obligation for the spiritual care of the patient. Hosp. Progr., 1935, 16: 260-2.—Brennan, F. J. The changing responsibility of the CathoUe hospital for the spiritual care of its patients. Ibid., 1938, 19: 336-8.— Christmas in hospital, as by various authors. S. Mary Hosp. Gaz., Lond., 1941, 47: 14-8.—Dicks, R. L. With benefit of clergy. Mod. Hosp., 1939, 53: No. 2, 53.------ Standards for the work of the chaplain in the general hospital. Hospitals, 1940, 14: No. 11, 42-8.—Donaldson, W. E. Religion in hos- pitals. Tr. Am. Hosp. Ass., 1923, 25: 543-52.—Erirkson, E. I. An outstanding community hospital maintained by the Luther- an church. Hosp. Management, 1939, 48: No. 2, 27-30 — Fitzpatrick, V. De P. Educating the general public with reference to the aims of the CathoUe hospital. Hosp. Progr., 1941, 22: 339.— Foster, L. E. Can reUgion contribute to hos- pital efficiency? Hospitals, 1936, 10: No. 7, 48-52.—Hatch, P. V. The Catholic hospital in mission sections. Hosp. Progr., 1938, 19: 363-5—Healy, J. L. Opportunities for religious education in the hospital. Ibid., 1937, 18: 259-61.— Kinsella, R. A. Science and religion in the hospital. Ibid., 1940, 21: 237-9.—Lamb. H. L. The purposes and achieve- ments of the Catholic hospital as a spiritual agency. Ibid., 1941, 22: 277.—McNamara, J. M. Sermon at pontifical mass. Ibid., 1936. 17: 230-2.— Moriarty, P. G. Catholic action through Catholic hospital service. Ibid., 1933, 14: 431-4.— Mulroy. J. R. The future of the church hospital. Ibid., 1935, 16: 230.—Nolin, M. An ordination in a Catholic hospital. Ibid., 1940, 21: 384.—O'Hara, E. V. The trends of today and the CathoUe hospital. Ibid., 1939, 20: 223-5.------The care of souls in the hospital as a national service. Ibid., 1941, 22: 341-4.—Olsen, J. A. P. H. A. discusses problems affecting Protestant hospitals. Hosp. Management, 1940, 50: No. 4, 29.—Schwitalla, A. M. The influence of the Catholic hospital in our modern society. Hosp. Progr., 1939, 20: 311-6. ------ The catholicity of the CathoUe hospital. Med. Missionary, Phila., 1941, 15: 14. ------Morris, I. E. [et al.] The purposes of the CathoUe hospital and medical social service. Hosp. Progr., 1941, 22: 35-52.—Smith, C. Religious responsibilities of the hospital; zeal for souls. Ibid., 1938, 19: 353-5.— Stuckelberger, R. Welche Unterstiitzung darf der Kranken- hausseelsorger von der Anstalt erwarten? Nosokomeion, Stuttg.. 1938, 31-3—Svoboda, B. Zur Wiederbegegnung von Arzt und Seelsorger im Krankenhaus. Ibid., 36-9.— Walsh, E. M. The CathoUe hospital in the Church's organiza- tion in the Inited States and in Canada. Hasp. Progr., 1941 22: 182. ---- Research service. Brownlie, J. L. The general hospital in relation to construc- tive medicine. Nosokomeion, Stuttg., 1936, 7: 22-5.—Cole, R. The modern hospital and medical progress. Science, 1926, 64: 123-30.—Cuyugan, S. Pace-setting r&le of hospitals in the practice of medicine. Month. Bull. Bur. Health, Manila, 1934, 14: 225-42— Eccles, W. McA. The hospital in relation to the achievements of this century in the field of medicine and surgery. Nosokomeion, Stuttg., 1938, 9: 293-5.—Engel- bach, A. G. Follow-up. Bull. Am. Hosp. Ass., 1935. 9: 109-21.—Importance (The) of a follow-up department in the cUnical investigation of disease. S. Barth. Hosp. J., Lond.. 1934, 41: 113-7.—Jutras, A. Les progres scientifique dans nos hopitaux. J. Hotel Dieu Montreal, 1939, 8: 314-26.—Katz, L. N. Clinical research in the non-university hospital. Proc Inst. M. Chicago, 1938-39, 12: 436-40.—Lacuna, D. The importance of research work in hospitals. Month. Bull. Bur. Health, Manila, 1940, 20: 91-5.—Nissen, H. A. The con- tinuous follow-up department of the modern hospital. N. England J. M., 1934, 211: 1048-51, ch. ------ Following up patients. Mod. Hosp., 1935, 44: 45.—Remy, C. E. Hospitals and the advancement of science. Sc. Month., 1940, 50: 536-9.—Scott, W. J. M. What place has research in the hospital? Tr. Am. Hosp. Ass., 1931, 33: 290-6.— Simmons, C. C. The follow-up of hospital patients. Bull. Am. CoU. Surgeons, 1933, 17: 10; 1936, 21: 165. --- Rules for patients. New York City. Saint Luke's Hospital. House regulations. N. Y., 1877 --- The same. N. Y., 1894. Sieben. Zur Gehorsamspflicht des Kranken. Zschr. ges. Krankenhauswes., 1935, 152-4. ---- Rural and small hospitals. Brown, O. J. The smaU hospital in a rural community. Tr. Am. Hosp. Ass., 1936, 38: 521-3.—Green, J. R., Knight, L. B. [et al.] The county hospital situation. Week. Bull. Jackson Co. M. Soc, 1941-42, 36: 443.—Hueston, R. M. How the small hospital may group its services effectively. Mod. Hosp., 1930, 34: 91.—Jennings, D. The small hospital; its need and its importance in certain communities. Hos- pitals, 1939, 13: No. 5, 94-6.—Proger, S. New service for smaU hospitals. Mod. Hosp., 1940, 55: No. 3, 79.—Rhea, W. G. The smaU town clinic hospital; its place in the com- munity. J. Tennessee M. Ass., 1940, 33: 197-202.— Salsbury, C. G. How a small hospital serves a large Indian community. Hospitals, 1938, 12: No. 3, 55-7—Schuler, R. B. The im- portance of the rural hospital; the rural life platform with reference to health. Hosp. Progr., 1940, 21: 335-9.—Sloan, R. P. Health center in the hills. Mod. Hosp., 1938, 50: No. 4. 56-60.—Southmayd, H. J. The rural hospital; an essential Unk in medical progress. Ibid., 1930, 35: 61-6.— Thrasher, J. W. Psychology in the rural hospital. Trained Nurse, 1935, 95: 421-3. ------ Value of psychology in the rural hospital. Hospitals, 1936, 10: No. 1, 20-2.—Wroth, P., jr. The hospital in the small town. Tr. Med. Chir. Fac. Univ. Maryland, 1925, 127: 287-96. ---- Social service. St Lotjis Hospital Social Service. Annual report. S. Louis, 2.-7., 1912/13-1916/18: 12.-13., 1922-23. Bailey. A. A., & Weiskotten, H. G. The problem of the discharged hospital patient. Hospitals, 1939, 13: No. 8, 13-7.—Bartlett, H. M. Should the Social Service Department see only those patients referred to it by the medical staff? Tr. Am. Hosp. Ass., 1939, 41: 203-11.—Berenguer, A. Asis- tencia social hospitalaria; reglamentaci6n de la asistencia hospitalaria. Tr. Congr. argent, med. gremial (1936) 1937, 2. Congr., 159-61.—Clark, L. N. Can a hospital afford not to have a department of social service? Tr. Am. Hosp. Ass., 1937, 39: 745-51.—Coakley, M. G. Medical social service in Memorial Hospital. Hospitals, 1941, 15: No. 6, 27-9.— Cockerill, E. Can the hospital afford not to have a depart- ment of social service? Tr. Am. Hosp. Ass., 1937, 39: 734- 45.— Consider duty to civilians, Dr B. W. Black tells Mid-West. Hosp. Management, 1941, 51: No. 5, 24; 49.—Dimchevsky, E. The psychiatric social worker in the general hospital. Hos- pitals, 1936, 10: No. 2, 73-5.—Emch, M. Integrating social service in the hospital; from the standpoint of the doctor. Ibid., 1941, 15: No. 12, 24-6.—Fullerton, J. G. The hospital's relations with the social service and other local agencies. Hosp. Progr., 1942, 23: 101-3.—Hart, A. O., & Hart, E. Some problems worthy of consideration in their organization and management. J. Michigan M. Soc, 1930, 29: 95-101.— Haywood, A. K. Should the Social Service Department interview aU hospital patients? Tr. Am. Hosp. Ass., 1939, 41: 196-203.—Johnsen, S. W. Report of the Advisory Committee HOSPITAL SERVICE 855 HOSPITAL SERVICE on AuxiUary Medical Services. J. M. Soc. N. .Terse;', 1941, 38: 234.—Josephson, E. M. Social service in the hospital. In his Merchants in Med., N. Y., 1941, 126.—Marcusson, E. Die soziale Anamnese im Krankenhaus. Acta med. scand., 1934, 82: 1-28.—Mills, A. B. The social service department; a study of salaries. Mod. Hosp., 1941, 57: No. 6, 49.—Money, F. M. Promoting good public relations through social service department. Hospitals, 1941, 15: No. 6, 40-3.—Moya Flamand, J. No basta la capacidad tecnica sino que precisa un respaldo y responsabihzaci6n politica. Med. d. hoy, Habana, 1939, 4: 392-6.—Munger, C W. The significance of estabUshed social service standards to the hospital. Tr. Am. Hosp. Ass., 1936, 38: 665-9.—Neff, R. E. Hospitals and their relationship to the White House conference. Ibid., 1932, 34: 241-55.— Peter. Uebt das Krankenhaus offentliche Fiirsorge fiir einen auswartigen Fiirsorgeverband? Zschr. ges. Krankenhauswes., 1941, 37: 168.—Proger, S. Hospital extension services. Hos- pitals, 1939, 13: 39-41.—Soule, T. H. Social service in a municipal hospital. Tr. Am. Hosp. Ass., 1937, 39: 873-8.— Tartakoff, R. Can a hospital afford not to have a depart- ment of social service? a discussion. Ibid., 752-61. Social service admitting in public hospitals. Ibid., 1938 40: 787-92.—Torres Torija. J. La clasificaci6n de los hospitales segun sus condiciones y su eficiencia medico- social. Reforma med., Lima, 1936, 22: 299-307.—Webb, C. W. The importance of established standards in a hos- pital social service section. Tr. Am. Hosp. Ass., 1936, 38: 661-5. ------ The future of social service in the life of a hospital. Ibid., 1939, 41: 211-20. ---- Specialization. Biesalski, K., Eckhardt, H. Fachkranken- hauser. 266p. 8? Berl., 1930. Carter, F. G. Should the general hospital treat mental and contagious cases? Mod. Hosp., 1932, 39: 45-8.—Sister St Ferdinand. The development of special hospitals. Hosp. Progr., 1941, 22: 228-32.—V. Zur facharztUchen Behandlung in kleinen Krankenhausern. Med. Klin., Berl., 1941, 37: 395. --- Standardization. American College of Surgeons. Manual of hospital standardization; history, development and progress of hospital standardization; detailed explanation of the minimum requirements. 96p. 8? Chic. [1938] Also another ed. 112p. 25cm. Chic. [1940] ---- The salient points in hospital standardi- zation. 6p. 26cm. [Chic, 1941?] Walsh, W. H. What is a hospital survey? 41. 18Mcm. [n. p., 1941?] Abel I, I. Report of the 1941 hospital standardization sur- vey; official announcement of the Ust of approved hospitals. BuU. Am. CoU. Surgeons, 1942, 27: 24.—Additional hospitals approved. J. Am. M. Ass., 1938, 110: 921; 1938, 111: 2510 — American College of Surgeons; hospital standardization con- ference to be held in Chicago, October 21-24. Hospitals, 1940, 14: No. 10, 44.—American College of Surgeons joins forces with American Medical Association in hospital census. J.Am. M. Ass., 1940, 115: 2086.—Annual Hospital Standardi- zation Conference. Surg. Gyn. Obst., 1941, 73: 411-3 — Approval of 2,484 hospitals announced at A. C. S. standardiza- tion conference. Hosp. Management, 1940, 50: No. 5, 17-9.— Approved hospitals in Nebraska. Nebraska M. J., 1938, 23: 195.—Approved hospitals of the United States, Canada, and other countries as of October 1, 1936. Bull. Am. Coll. Surgeons, 1936, 20: 207-72.—Arizona hospitals urged to raise standards of service. Hosp. Management, 1940, 49: No. 2, 20.—Bishop, H. E. Adequate standards of hospital service. Hospitals, 1942, 16: No. 5, 60.—Blaine, E. S. AppUcation of the principles of hospital standardization from the viewpoint of the radi- ologist. Bull. Am. Coll. Surgeons, 1936, 21: 22.—Boyd, P. W. Why standardize the hospital? Virginia M. Month., 1926-27, 53: 387-90.—Braithwaite, W. E. Standardization and simpli- fication. Tr. Am. Hosp. Ass., 1937, 39: 822-32.—Coker, G. N. Minimum standards for organization of community hospitals of 20 to 40 beds. Bull. Am. Hosp. Ass., 1929, 3: 429-32.— Cotton, F. J., Gorrell, J. E. [et al.] Pertinent problems relating to hospital administration and hospital standardization. Bull. Am. Coll. Surgeons, 1938, 23: 106-21.—Crain, K. C. Small hospitals raise standards with aid of Bingham Associates Fund. Hosp. Management, 1941, 52: No. 4, 18-20.—Crand ill, W. C. Application of the principles of hospital standardization from the viewpoint of the hospital trustee. Bull. Am. Coll. Surgeons, 1936, 21: 18.—Crile, G. W. What the hospital standardization movement means to the present-day practice of medicine. Ibid., 1930, 14: 11. ------ Another year of hospital standardization; the 1936 survey. Ibid., 1937, 22: 65.—Davis, N. E. The future hospital and standardization. Ibid., 1926, 10: 27-9.—Doane, J. C. Government and volun- tary hospitals; can we justify a double standard? Mod. Hosp., 1935, 45: No. 6, 37-40.—Dujarric de la Riviere, It. Un point particulier de l'organisation hospitahere americaine: Hospital fs^fifw^p11 1* mi£imTum standard. Rev. hyg., Par., 1926 ill P/-776;—Fesler, P. H. Application of the principles of afministrtaofarB,Z,Mtl0A fr°? ^viewpoint of ?he Tospita FitzDarirk F ^i,"' CoU. Surgeons, 1936, 21: 20.- ruzpairick, L. A. Educational opportunities of hosnital standardization Hosp. Progr., 1927, 8: 14-7 -Foord A G Application of the principles of hospital standardization from the viewpoint of the clinical pathologist. Bull. Am Coll wnrfh°nSlV 9,36'tI1: 20.-Gately, W. A. Standard zarion; is it worth while? Hospitals, 1937, 11: No. 6, 114-6.-Graham! S,',r^«, ^ n^ltal ^r,0groam of the American College of fr»°ys- Bull. Am. Coll. Surgeons, 1942, 27: 21-4 —____ Abcll. I. [et al.] Hospital standardization; report of the 1941 conference m Boston. Ibid., 21-72.-Harbin, R. M How ■Ix, /iP hosPltal can assist the small hospital in complying with the requirements. Ibid., 1929, 13: 36.—Haynes, T. H. Maintaining standards of hospital service during the war. Hospitals, 1942 16: No. 4, 90-2.-Hedlund, E. fActivity of ioIaH°s.Pitals Standardization Committee] Sven. lak. tidn., 1936, 33: 355-60.—Highsmith, J. F. Application of the principles of hospitai standardization from the viewpoint of the medical staff member. Bull. Am. Coll. Surgeons, 1936 21: U-Hoffmaiiii W. Ergebnisse der Verhandlungen des irlia Werausschusses fur das offentliche Krankenhauswesen 1932 Khn. Wschr 1933, 12: 1659-61.—Hospitals registered °y thei American Medical Association. J. Am. M. Ass., 1939 112: 933-95.—Hospital standardization. Bull. Am. Coll' Surgeons, 1935, 19: 113.—Hospital standardization; report of the 1934 conference in Boston. Surg. Gyn. Obst., 1935, 60: 618-34.—Hospital standardization; report of the 1936 con- ference in Philadelphia. Bull. Am. Coll. Surgeons, 1937, 22: ■ i—HosP>tal standardization: report of the 1937 conference in Chicago. Ibid., 1938, 23: 69.—Hospital standardization; report of the 1938 conference in New York. Ibid., 1939, 24: 177.—Hospital standardization; report of the 1939 conference in Philadelphia. Ibid., 1940, 25: 57-106.—Hospital standard- ization conference of the American College of Surgeons. Hos- pitals, 1941, 15: No. 12, 23.—Hospital surveys by the American College of Surgeons. Army M. Bull., 1941, 56: 75-9.—Illinois hospitals registered by the American Medical Association. IlUnois M. J., 1935, 68: 113; 191.—Jarrett, L. E. Professional standards affecting hospital practice. Hospitals, 1939„ 13: 75-7.—Josephson, E. M. How a hospital wins A. C. S. ap- proval. In his Merchants in Med., N. Y., 1941, 149.—Lewis, D. S. The minimum standard as applied to internal medicine. Ann. CUn. M., 1926-27, 5: 780-3.—List of A. C. of S. ap- proved hospitals shows gains. Mod. Hosp., 1930, 34: 124-32.— Long, LeR. The responsibility of the Fellows of the American College of Surgeons in hospital standardization. Bull. Am. Coll. Surgeons, 1926, 10: 10-2.—McCarthy, A. M. Practical standards of medical service in small hospitals. Hospitals, 1938, 12: No. 7, 41-5.—MacEachern, M. T. Report on hos- pital standardization for the year 1925, including list of ap- proved hospitals of 35 beds or more in the United States, Canada and foreign countries. BuU. Am. Coll. Surgeons, 1926, 10: 49-63. ------ Summary of the 1929 hospital standardization survey, 12 years in retrospect. Ibid., 1929, 13: 3-8. ------ Hospital standardization. Proc. Panpacific Surg. Conf., 1929, 1. Conf., 211-3. ------ The working principles of hospital standardization. J. Lancet, 1934, 54: 162-8. ——■—- Two decades of hospital standardization. BuU. Am. Hosp. Ass., 1935, 9: 32-43. ■-----Hospital standardization. Hosp. Management, 1938, 46: No. 4, 8-12. History, development, and progress of hospital stand- ardization in the United States and Canada. Nosokomeion, Stuttg., 1938. 9: 24-31. ------ Twenty years of hospital standardization. Surg. Gyn. Obst., 1938, 66: 421. ------ The 1938 Clinical Congress: 21st annual hospital standardiza- tion conference. Ibid., 1939, 68: 431. ------ Revised manual of hospital standardization. Bull. Am. Coll. Surgeons, 1940, 25: 243. ------ Hospitals, administrators, and hos- pital standardization. Puerto Rico Health Bull., 1940, 4: 348-64. ------ Twenty-second annual hospital standardiza- tion conference. Surg. Gyn. Obst., 1940, 70: 381. Reports show many hospitals exceed basic requirements for approval. Hosp. Management, 1941, 51: No. 2, 18. ------ Twenty-third annual hospital standardization conference. Surg. Gyn. Obst., 1941, 72: 543. ------ Twenty-fourth annual Hospital Standardization Conference. Ibid., 1942, 74: 645.—McMahon, A. Function of the resident in maintaining the medical standards. Hosp. Progr., 1933, 14: 381-4.—■ Martin, F. H. The Catholic Hospital Association of the United States and Canada as a factor in the hospital world of to-day in cooperation with the standardization movement of the American College of Surgeons. Ibid., 1926, 7: 302. ----—- Presentation of the 13th annual report of Hospital Standardiza- tion. Bull. Am. Coll. Surgeons, 1930, 14: 3-7. ------ Hos- pital standardization from the community standpoint. J. Lancet, 1934, 54: 139-45.—Matas, R. Politics and hospitals n their relation to hospital standardization. Bull. Am. Coll. Surgeons, 192G, 10: 4-9. Also Memphis M. J., 1926, 3: 230-4. ------ The hospital standardization movement. Bull. Am. Coll. Surgeons, 1927, 11: 3-6.—Miller, C. J. The inception and growth of the hospital standardization movement. Proc. Panpacific Surg. Conf., 1929, 1. Conf., 204-10.—Munroe, A. R. AppUcation of the principles of hospital standardization from the viewpoint of the medical educationist. Bull. Am. CoU. Surgeons, 1936, 21: 23.—Nineteen hundred forty-one (The) survey of hospitals; plan developed for coordination in dis- HOSPITAL SERVICE 856 HOSPITAL SERVICE uibutinn of questionnaires and inspection of hospitals with iIn- American Medical Association. Ibid., 1941, 26: 95. - Nineteenth annual hospital standardization report, including list of approved hospitals in the United States, Canada, and other countries as of October 1. 1936; the 1936 survey. Ibid., 1936 20: 1S5-206.—Preview (A) of the 1937 hospital standard- ization report. Ibid., 1937, 22: 235-8.- Rankin, W. S. Modi- f\ mg professional standards in a small hospital. Mod. Hosp., I'.ab, 16: No. 4, 57-9.—Rating of a hospital. Lancet, Lond., 1937. 2: 339.—Sanders, R. L. Approved hospitals; an ap- pieciation. Mississippi Doctor. 1936-37, 14: No. 9, 22.— Sanger. H. F. The American Medical Association and hos- pitaK. Bull. Am. Hosp. Ass., 1935, 9: 26; 174.—Satchwell, II. H. Report of the Committee on Hospitals and Medical Education. J. M. Soc. N. Jersey, 1934, 31: 275.—Schwitalla, A. M. The hospital in retrospect and introspect. Bull. Am. CoU. Surgeons, 1935, 19: 19-23.—Sister Mary Agnes. The effect of the standardization program of the American college if surgeons on hospital conditions. Hosp. Progr., 1938, 19: 119-21.-- Special features of the hospital standardization conference. Hull. Am. Coll. Surgeons, 1936, 21: 45.—Stepha- nie, M. Application of the principles of hospital standardiza- tion from the viewpoint of the nurse. Ibid., 24.—Twentieth annual hospital standardization report, including list of ap- proved hospitals in the United States, Canada, and other countries as of October 1, 1937. Ibid., 1937, 22: 253-74 — Twenty-first annual hospital standardization report including list of approved hospitals in the United States, Canada, and other countries as of October 1, 1938. Ibid., 1938, 23: 293-401. Also Hosp. Management, 1938, 46: No. 3, 18. Also Hospitals, 1938, 12: No. 10, 59 (16.- Twenty-fourth annual Hospital Standardization Report, including list of approved hospitals in the United States, Canada, and other countries as of Octo- ber 1, 1941. Bull. Am. Coll. Surgeons, 1941, 2fi: 295-393.— Twenty-second annual hospital standardization conference. Ibid., 1939, 24: 264-7.—Twenty-second annual hospital standardization report; including list of approved hospitals in the United States, Canada, and other countries as of October 1, 1939; the 1939 survey. Ibid., 313 408.— Twenty-third annual hospital standardization report; including list of ap- proved hospitals in the United States, Canada, and other countries as of October I, 1910. Ibid., 1910. 25: 269-368.— Waite. L. Application of the principles of hospital standardiza- tion from the viewpoint of the dietitian. Ibid., 1936, 21: 25.—Walsh, W. H. The n-sponsibility of the medical staff for the maintenance of piofcssional standards. Hospitals, 1937, 11: No. 6, 45-8. Walson. ('. M. Hospital standardiza- tion requirements of the American College of Surgeons and their attainment by Army hospitals. Army M. Bull., 1937, No. 39, 51-7.—Zeitler, R. Normung im Krankenhauswesen. Nosokomeion, Stuttg., 1937, 8: 171-5. ---- Visitors. Beiersdorfer, H. In restraint of visitors. Mod. Hosp., 1939, 52: No. 5, 55.—Celotti. A. Le visite ai malati negU ospedali generali. Osp. maggiore, Milano, 1939, 27: 241-4.— Krichbaum, J. Volunteers control visitors. Mod. Hosp., 1940, 55: No. 2, 59.—Price, A. L. Hospital visitors. Hosp. Manage- ment, 1938, 46: No. 5, 24. ---- in wartime. A., K. F. We are prepared; St Thomas's Hospital. Nurs. Times, Lond., 1939, 35: 1360-2.------We are prepared; the Radcliffe Infirmary, Oxford. Ibid., 1474-6. ------ We are prepared; Ashridge hospital. Ibid., 1526-8. ------ Hospitals carry on. Ibid., 1940, 36: 975.—Advice to civihan hospitals in providing emergency service. Mod. Hosp., 1942, 58: 41-4.— A[gnew] G. H. What can our hospitals do? Hospitals, 1942, 16: No. 2, 68.—Amberg, R. M. National preparedness pro- gram in hospitals; resident medical staff, interns, and residents. Ibid., 1941, 15: No. 5, 54.—Army not to encroach on civiUan needs, Magee says. Mod. Hosp., 1942, 58: 108.—B[acon] A. S. Meeting our national emergency. Hospitals, 1942, 16: No. 2, 69.—Ball, G. Bart's in the war of 1939. S. Barth. Hosp. J War Bull., Lond., 1939, 1: 32.—Black, B. W. The present trend toward specialization in medicine, surgery and hospital administration in relation to national preparedness. Bull. Am. Coll. Surgeons, 1941, 26: 87-9.—Civilian hospitals serving soldiers and sailors. South. M. k S., 1940, 102:447.—Cleveland Lakeside Hospital Unit and Dayton Medical SpeciaUst group now on active iniUtary duty. Ohio M. .]., 1942, 38: 160.— Complete i A") war time plan of hospital organization [Great Britain] J. Am. M. Ass., 1939, 112: 1738. Cotton, L. British hospitals organized to meet every war-time contingency. Hosp Management, 1939, 48: No. 6, 19.—Elliott, P. C. Medical staff adopts program for use in event of emergency. Ibid. 1941, 51: No. 5, 30.—Emch, A. F. The role of hospitals in the national defense. Bull. Am. Coll. Surgeons, 1941, 26: 166- 71.—Emergency hospital scheme; accommodation and fees for paying patient- Brit. Al. I . 1941, 2: Suppl., 19.—Emergency problema facing hospitals. Hospitals, 1941, 15: No. 12, 13-5.— Facilities for care of casualties. Mod. Hosp., 1942, 58: No. 2 insert, 11-3.—Hemnger, F. Program for patriots. Ibid., 1941, 57: No. 4, 53.—Hospital coordination (London letter) J. Am! M. Ass., 1941, 116: 1175.— Hospital preparedness requires increase in duties for aU personnel. Hosp. Management, 1941, 51: No. 5, 20.—Hospital i.-ception of casualties. Pub. Health! Lond., 1941-42, 55: 71.—Hospitals and air raids; organization of a city casualty hospital. Brit. M. J., 1941, 2: 9S-100.- Hospital civil defense plan as organized by New York Infirmary for Women and Children. Women in Med., 1912, No. 75, 14-ti. Hunter, M. I. Hospital preparedness. Hospitals, 1941, 15: No. 9, 71. Hyde, II. V. Z. The hospital in civilian defense. N. York State .1. M., 1942, 42: 76. Jaque.s. I). Britain's hospitals carry on: Red Cross Courier, 1941, 21: No. 4, 9.— Jinga, P. Projet de creation de zones sanitaires. Sess. Off. internat. docum. mid. mil., 1937, 7. Sess., 95 lit). Johnson. L. W. The hospital and the national emergency. J. Florida M. Ass., 1941-42, 28: 484-9.—Jones, E. W. Maintaining the individual's health as a defense measure. Hospitals, 1911, 15: No. 10, 40-2.—London hospitals carry on. J. Am. M. Ass., 1940, 115: 1651.—London hospitals carry on during air raids. Ibid., 19-11, 116: 1018.—London hospitals carry on during bombardment. Ibid., 1940, 115: 2014.—London hospitals carry on services in spite of bombardment. Connecticut M. J., 1940, 4: 667.—MacEachern, M. T. Hospitals plan for defense. Mod. Hosp., 1940, 55: No. 4, 03.------Wartime program of Canadian hospitals. Bull. Am. Coll. Surgeons, 1942, 27: 10.— MacKintosh, J. M. Hospital organization for war. Hospitals, 1942, 16: No. 4, 17-9— Masoner, K. W. Hospital and health needs receive attention in preparedness program. Hosp. Management, 1940, 50: No. 2, 11.—Midland (A) hospital, bombed but at work. Nurs. Times, Lond., 1940, 36: 13-14.— New England group tells effects of defense program on hospitals Hosp. Management, 194 1, 52: No.4, 23.—Oseroff, A. Coordina- tion of local hospital facilities for war emergency in the Pitts- burgh area. Hospitals, 1942, 16: No. 2, 43-7- Ouverlure du service hospitalier de lancienne clinique Antoine-Chantin. Presse med., 1940, 48: 947.—Parran, MacLean, B. C. [et al.] Six views on the emergency; how President's proclamation affects the nation's hospitals. Mod. Hosp., 1941, 57: 4.'!. Ponton, T. R. OCD outlines emergency duty of hospital personnel; plan worked out for Chicago area offers example of organization of city's facilities. Hosp. Mangement, 1942, 53: No. 2, 13-5.—Pratt, O. G. A community hospital prepares for emergency. J. Maine M. Ass., 1941, 32: 262-4.—Preparedness session girds civilian hospitals for present emergency. Mod. Hosp., 1940, 55: No. 4, 65.—Problems of hospital preparedness main concern of Boston convention. Hosp. Management, 1940, 50: No. 4, 15.—Purpose (The) of auxiliary hospitals. Lancet, Lond., 1940, 2: 473.—Reynolds, C. R. Military hospitahzation in a national emergency. Pennsylvania Health, 1941-42, 2: No. 10, 12-20.—S., F. R. C. Plight of consultants in bombed areas. Brit. M. J., 1941, 1: 574.—St Thomas's Hospital moves to the country. Nurs. Times, Lond., 1941, 37: 366.—Schickele. L'hospitalisation en temps de guerre k l'interieur du territoire national. Sess. Off. internat. docum. mid. mil. (1934) 1936, 4. Sess., 31-53.—Second (A) contingent of the American hospital unit. J. Am. M. Ass., 1940, 115: 2099.—Sectional meetings of American College of Surgeons stress hospital preparedness. Hosp. Management, 1941, 52: No. 4, 26.—Smith, W. H. Role of civilian hospital in the program of preparedness. Hospitals, 1940, 14: No. 10, 23-8. ------ Preparedness of the hospital. Ibid., 1941, 15: No. 10, 20-7.—Steele, M. F. Keeping hospitals geared to civilian needs. Ibid., 1942, 16: No. 5, 27-9.—Tullmann, A. Die Aufgaben des Fiirsorgedienstes im Krankenhaus in Kriegs- zeiten. Deut. MiUtiirarzt, 1940, 5:390 (Abstr.) (microfilm)— United States hospitals to expand role as bulwarks of health in 1942. Hosp. Management, 1942, 53: No. 3, 23.—War time hospital organization [Great Britain] J. Am. M. Ass., 1939, 112: 1272.—Washburn, F. A. Role of civiUan hospital in reenforcing the medical department of the Army in formation of an expeditionary force. Hospitals, 1940, 14: No. 10, 20-2. ;-----Smith, W. H. [et al.] A symposium; the civiUan hospital in the preparedness program for national defense. Ibid., 19-34.—We are prepared; King's College Hospital. Nurs. Times, Lond., 1939, 35: 1336-8.—Weldon, L. O. A note con- cerning the transfer of patients to Fort Staton, New Mexico. Hosp. News, Wash., 1939, 6: No. 2, 18-21.—Wilhelm, N. A., Johnson, S. [et al.] Panel discussion; meeting the problems of rendering adequate care of the patient and maintaining quaUty standards of service during the present period of preparedness and national emergency. Bull. Am. Coll. Surgeons, 1942, 27: 40-51. HOSPITAL ship. Arthur, W. H. The hospital ship Missouri [unfinished ms. in the possession of General Arthur at the time of his death, 1936] 18 1. 4: [n. pl., n. d.] U. S. Army Hospital Ship Missouri [Album of photographs] 48p. photos, obi. 4. [n. pl., n. d.] Aboard a British hospital ship. Nurs. Times, Lond., 1939, 35: 1365.—Arnaud, M. L'organisation et le fonctionnement du navire-hopital Mar6chal-Lyautey. Bull. Acad, med., Par., 1939, 3. sir., 121: 671-8.—Birth of a hospital ship. Nurs. Times, Lond., 1939, 35: 1441.—Bomb hospital ships. J. Am. M. Ass., 1940, 115: 313.—Bombing hospital ships. Ibid., 1941, 116: 2421.—Bombing of a hospital ship. Ibid., 117: 58 — Bombing of British hospital ships. Lancet, Lond., 1940, 1: 1103.—Bragman, L. J. A revolutionary hospital ship. Mil. Surgeon, 1927, 61: 1 53-5. -Comite (Le) international de la HOSPITAL SHIP 857 HOSPITAL STAFF Croix-Rouge et la guerre; violations de la Convention de Geneve; navires hopitaux. Rev. internat. Croix Rouge, 1940, 22: 523.—Deliberate attacks on hospital ships; enemy hospital ship detained as a hostage [London letter] J. Am. M. Ass., 1941, 117: 876.—GrandeHiment. Les navires-hopitaux. Rev. internat. Croix Rouge, 1938, 20: 395-427, 8 pl.—Hospital (The) sails the seas. Mod. Hosp., 1936, 46: No. 4, 72.—Hutchison, A. Combined ambulance and hospital launch. Med. Off., Lond., 1942, 67: 29, plan.—Inside a hospital ship. Nurs. Times, Lond., 1939, 35: 1148.—Johnson, L. W. The story of our hospital ships. Red Cross Courier, 1937, 17: 21-3. Problems of emergency hospital ships. Hosp. Management, 1938, 45: No. 3, 14-6. ------ Hospital ships of the World War: lessons to be learned from them. Mil. Surgeon, 1938, 82: 185-93. Also repr. ------ Hospital ships. U. S. Nav. M. Bull., 1938, 36: 197-233, 4 pl. ------ U. S. S. Relief, the Fleet hospital ship. Mil. Surgeon, 1939, 85: 372. Also repr.— Kubitzki, P. Das Grosse Lazarettschiff, seine Einrichtung und Verwendung. Deut. MiUtararzt, 1939, 4: 513-21.—Lattes, E., & Salvi del Pero, C. Risultati di alcune indagini sulle condizioni atmosferiche nell'interno di una nave ospedale stazionante nei Mar Rosso. Ann. med. nav., Roma, 1937, 43: 522-33.—Li Causi, G. Rendiconto operativo di tre anni di attivita. chi- rurgica su navi ospedali. Ibid., 1938, 44: 456-60.—Lollke. Deutsche Lazarettschiffe. Deut. med. Wschr., 1939, 65: 1793-5.—Martelli, V. Le navi-ospedale. Ann. med. nav., Roma, 1926, 1: 43-55.—Oudard. Les navires-hopitaux en temps de guerre. J. mid. Bordeaux, 1928, 58: 955-60.— Pennaneac'h, J. La vie du marin de Terre-Neuve; le navire- hopital des Oeuvres de Mer. Presse mid., 1933, 41: 1661.— Ricci, R. W. Italy's floating hospitals in East Africa. Trained Nurse, 1936, 96: 240-2— Roddis, L. H. The U. S. hospital ship Red Rover (1862-65) Mil. Surgeon, 1935, 77: 91-8.— Schroeder, E., & Wilson, R. A hospital afloat. Canad. Nurse, 1942, 38: 121.—Solcard. Les appareils de transports des blesses k bord dans la marine francaise. Sess. Off. internat. docum. med. mil., 1937, 7. Sess., 247-59.—Visita (La) di S. A. R. il Principe di Piemonte alia nave ospedale Gradisca. Ann. med. nav., Roma, 1939, 45: 52. HOSPITAL social service. N. Y., v.1-28, 1919-33. Ceased pubUcation. HOSPITAL staff. See also Interne; Nurse. A. M. A. Bureau of Legal Medicine and Legislation. Right of a governing board of a hospital to exclude cultists and other undesirable practitioners. BuU. Am. M. Ass., 1936, 31, 4: 80-2.—Bachmeyer, A. C. Institutes estabUshed to meet increased demand for training. Hosp. Management, 1941, 51: No. 2, 26.—Borden, R. P. Periculum in mora. Hospitals, 1940, 14: No. 7, 16-20.—Borowski, A. J. Subsidiary workers; W. P. A. trains 50,000 helpers. Mod. Hosp., 1941, 56: No. 5, 56.—Butler, W. P. Survey of the ratio of employees to patients in 20 CaUfornia hospitals. Hospitals, 1939, 13: No. 4, 92.— Carter, F. G. Educated and trained personnel essential for maintaining proper standards of service. Ibid., No. 12, 18- 21.—Christian, S. L. Patient-personnel relationships in marine hospitals. Hosp. News, Wash., 1938, 5: No. 18, 1-6.—Dabbs, C. H. Why titles of hospital's chief executive should be uniform. Hosp. Management, 1935, 39: 24.—D'Este, G. Fabbisogno di personale per l'assistenza immediata ed ausiliaria per un ospedale di 500 letti. Osp. maggiore, Milano, 1926, 3. ser., 14: 214-7.—Doane, J. C. Priorities and perquisites. Mod. Hosp., 1941, 56: 63.—Duff, A. Staffing of hospitals. Brit. M. J., 1941, 2: 790.—Dwyer, W. E. Staffing the community hospital. Hospitals, 1941, 15: No. 2, 47.—Elaut, L. [Instruction of medi- cal assistant; nurses and social workers] Arch. mid. sociale, Brux., 1938, 1: 125-39.—Emch, A. F. Survey of hospital per- sonnel. Hospitals, 1938, 12: No. 7, 69-72.—Employment of hospital helpers requisition. Brit. J. Nurs., 1942, 90: 36.— Fingerhood, B., Kneifl, M. R., & Wright, L. H. Report of the Committee on Nomenclature in Uniform Staff Organization, 1936. Tr. Am. Hosp. Ass., 1936, 38: 173-5.—Hayhow, E. C. The training of hospital personnel. Ibid., 1939, 41: 417-21. ■----- MiUtary and industrial expansions affect hospital personnel. Hospitals, 1942, 16: No. 5, 41-3.—Hirschfelder, A. D. Some methods used in the teaching of clinical clerks and physical diagnosis. J. Ass. Am. M. Coll., 1932, 7: 38-41.— Hockett, A. J. The future of staff organization in the voluntary hospital. Hospitals, 1937, 11: No. 2, 38-40.—House officers for small hospitals. Mod. Hosp., 1940, 55: No. 5, 64.—Hyde, F. S. Maintenance staff plays important role in service to patients. Hosp. Management, 1942, 53: No. 5, 74.—Jensen, A. C. Need for training orderlies and attendants recognized by hospital and nursing groups. Ibid., 1941, 52: 37-40.— Josephson, E. M. Calibre of hospital staffs. In his Merchants in Med., N. Y., 1941, 135.—Kenny, D. M. Notes on the train- ing of native hospital orderUes. Kenya E. Afr. M. J., 1927728, 4: 62-4.—Korsell, M. Competent personnel for small hospital. Hospitals, 1941, 15: No. 5, 52.—LaBelle, A. M. The hospital and its housekeeper. Ibid., 1936, 10: No. 6, 57.—Ladd, *. C. Housekeeper plays major role. Mod. Hosp., 1941, 57: JNo. 6, 73.—Loughran, W. A yardstick for municipal hospitai per- sonnel. Hospitals, 1942, 16: 106.—McDavitt. T. V Right of the governing board of a hospital to determine which practi- tioners may and which practitioners may not use hospital facilities. Proc. Ann. Congr. M. Educ, 1931, 59: 62—Mac- Eachern, M T. Factors that influence ratio of personnel to patients. Mod. Hosp., 1930, 35: 73-8—Markey. S. E. Second line of defense; Cleveland cooperates with N. Y. A Ibid 1941 56: No. 5 57.—Masoner, K. W. How will hospital personnel ht into the selective service program? Hosp. Management 1940, 50: No. 4, 13.—Neff, R. E. Meet the hospital hostess! Mod. Hosp., 1941, 56: No. 6, 53.—Norenberg, W. Verant- wortung und Vertrauen gegenuber dem Krankenhausbeamten. 4schr. ges. Krankenhauswes., 1937, 508-10.—O'Hanlon, G. Training and education of hospital personnel. Hospitals, 1938, 12: 23-6.—Orlov, M. Personnel organization, Massachusetts General Hospital. Ibid., 1941, 15: No. 7, 28-40.—Pennell, E. H., Mountin, J. W., & Pearson, K. Prevailing ratios of personnel to patients in hospitals offering general care. Ibid 1938, 12: No. 11, 42-7. Also Tr. Am. Hosp. Ass., 1938, 40: 639-49.—Perrott, G. St J., & Dorn, H. F. Imminent needs for hospital personnel. Hospitals, 1942, 16: No. 3, 46.—Pinkerton, M. Subsidiary workers in the general hospital. Ibid., 1939, 13: No. 3, 21.—Porter, R. M. Educational standards and per- sonnel. Tr. Am. Hosp. Ass., 1938, 40: 188-93.—Riese, M. The personnel in the small hospital. Hospitals, 1940, 14: No. 9, 66-8.—Salsbury, C. G. Self study and personnel development. Ibid., 1941, 15: No. 8, 45.—Scarcity (The) of hospital personnel and its solution. Ibid., No. 11, 18.—Scheidt, A. H. What I expect of my housekeeper. Mod. Hosp., 1941, 57: No. 4, 106.— Sherrard, G. J. Training of employees. Hospitals, 1940, 14: No. 10, 85.—Smith, M. E. Employee training. Tr. Am. Hosp. Ass., 1938, 40: 176-80.—Stout, M. L. Hospital personnel and the pubUc. Hospitals, 1937, 11: No. 7, 91-3.—Train WPA workers to help reUeve hospital shortage. Hosp. Management, 1942, 53: No. 2, 44.—University hospital emplovees' credit union. Univ. Hosp. Bull., Ann Arb., 1941, 7: 22.—Vanderlip, F. Educating women workers for hospitals. Hospitals. 1941, 15: No. 11,20-2.—Voluntary hospitals; Labor Relations Act. Ibid., 1940, 14: No. 9, 53-7.—Waddell, E. C. The large hospital with an all-graduate staff. Ibid., 1936, 10: No. 11, 74-6.—Wald, R. Krankenhausarzte und Krankenhausschwestern als Dichter und Schriftsteller. Wien. med. Wschr., 1938, 88: 1339; 1939, 89: 27.—Waldmann. Hauspolizei. Zschr. ges. Kranken- hauswes., 1926, 22: 210-2.—Works Project Administration trains hospital helpers for war and emergency needs. Med. Rec, N. Y., 1942, 155: No. 6, 8-10.—Works Project Adminis- tration begins program to train hospital attendants. Hosp. Management, 1941, 51: No. 5, 36. ---- auxiliary and voluntary. New York, N. Y. Society of the Lying-in Hospital of the City of New York. Annual report of the ladies auxiliary to the society 1906-7. N. Y., 1907. [Shelby, M. F.] The little secretary; the auxiliary of Bellin Memorial Hospital, Green Bay, Wis. 44p\ 8? Green Bav. Wis., 1935. Baker (Mrs.) W. The purpose, requirements and pledge of voluntary aid service. Tr. Am. Hosp. Ass., 1939, 41: 630-2.— Benson, J. C. Volunteer service for women's auxiliaries. Ibid., 1938, 40: 224-31. -----■ Work of lay-women in hos- pitals attracts large attendance. Hosp. Management, 1941, 52: No. 4, 27; 49.—Bong, E. Those subsidiary workers. Mod, Hosp., 1937, 49: No. 3, 63.—Britton, J. T. Ventures of volun- teers. Ibid., 1936, 46: No. 1, 52-6.—Brown, W. H. Con- tribution of hospital auxiUaries to national defense. Hospitals, 1941, 15: No. 7, 46.—Campbell, R. B. The work of our women's board. Ibid., 1940, 14: No. 2, 68-70.—Del Valle, D. El personal auxiUar de nuestros hospitales; numero, reclutamiento y escalafon. Rev. As. med. argent., 1933, 46: 2274-80 — Fishbein, M. The role of the woman's auxiUary in the modern hospital. Hospitals, 1936, 10: No. 6, 14-6.—Frankenfield, M. W. Hospital auxiliaries; a symposium; what has been accompUshed in auxiUary service? Ibid., 1940, 14: No. 6, 91-3.—Goldbloom, A. E. B. Can a hospital afford to be without a woman's auxiUary? Tr. Am. Hosp. Ass., 1939, 41: 595-8. Also Hospitals, 1939, 13: No. 10, 57— Harris, L. Volunteer service in relation to nursing and hospitals. J. M. Ass. Georgia, 1942, 31: 72.—Horton, E. A., Specific examples of services given to hospitals by auxiliaries. Tr. Am. Hosp. Ass., 1939, 41: 602-7.—Hoyt. G. R. Volunteer aids are valu- able. Mod. Hosp., 1939, 52: No. 5, 63—McKee, E. M. How best can voluntary service function in the hospital? Tr. Am. Hosp. Ass., 1939, 41: 607-10.—Manley, M. E. The subsidiary worker, attendant, in the nursing care of the sick. Ibid., 523-9 —Mason, E. F. A few of the advantages of a woman's hospital auxiliary. Ibid., 615-30.—Matthews, F. J. Canadian women's work in defense. Hospitals, 1941, 15: No. 11, 23 — Matthews, G. The activities of the Ladies' Auxiliary Board of Governors. Tr. Am. Hosp. Ass., 1939, 41: 598-601.—Maxwell, D. C. What place does the auxiUary have in promoting pubhc relations? Ibid., 613-5.—Merrill, A. P. The relation of physician and trustee to voluntary hospital service. Hospitals, 1940 14- No 11, 105-12.—Meyer, B. F. Volunteer hospital service for women. Ibid., 1941, 15: 17-20. ------ Volunteers to the rescue. Mod. Hosp., 1941, 57: No. 2, 47.—Meyer, R. F. Junior League service in hospitals. Hospitals, 1941, 15: No. 12, 85-7.—Parnall, C. G. Organization and management HOSPITAL STAFF 858 HOSPITAL STAFF of volunteer service in hospitals. Hosp. Topics, 1939, 17: No. 2, 12.—Piper, L. K. Volunteer services. Am. J. Nurs., 1941, 41: 1135.—Power, M. E. Volunteer service in hospitals. Hospitals, 1941, 15: No. 8, 53-5.—Preparation (The) of auxiliary hospital personnel in the government's program. Hosp. Progr., 1941, 22: 130-4.—Quinn, M. L. The Ladies' auxiliary at St Mary's hospital, Montreal. Hospitals, 1940, 14: No. 4, 36.—Rhynas, O. W. Value of well-organized hos- pital auxiliary units. Ibid., 1941, 15: No. 2, 30-2.—Schiller, M. B. Organizing a volunteer system. Ibid., 1939, 13: No. 11, 58-61. ------ Volunteers; asset or anathema. Mod. Hosp., 1941, 56: No. 2, 73.—Schrocder, A. H. The need of special training for the hospital social worker. Tr. Am. Hosp. Ass., 1939, 41: 220--4.—Shorey, E. D. Relationship of the women's auxiUary to the administrator and board of trustees. Ibid., 610-3.—Sister Henrietta. The subsidiary worker; selection, duties, and contiol. Bull. Am. Coll. Surgeons, 1940, 25: 103-6.—Sloan, R. P. Its aiiMliarv is hospital's strength. Mod. Hosp., 1935, 44: 68-72.—Stanley, H. V also stands for volunteers. Hospitals, 1941, 15: No. 10, 43-7.—Success story of a hospital auxiUary. Hosp. Topics, 1938, 16: No. 11, 16.—Sweeney, W. B. Women's auxiliaries and junior auxiU- aries in public relations. Hospitals, 1942, 16: No. 2, 88.— Tufts. Women's auxiUaries as public relations agencies. Ibid., 1941, 15: No. 8, 56.—Vanderlip, F. A. Volunteer service for women in hospitals today. Ibid., 1940, 14: No. 11, 23-7.— Whitman, T. C. Opportunities for women in hospital service. Ibid.. 28-31. ---- clerical. Circulaire du 17 octobr'e 1936 k MM. les Pr6fets; envoi d'un statut-type pour le personnel administratif des 6tabUssements hospitaliers publics. Bull. Min. san. pub., Par., 1936, 81-8.— Gault, A. E. Nurse clerks. Am. J. Nurs., 1942, 42: 151.— Hess, R. What makes a medical secretary? Med Hosp., 1940, 54: No. 5, 86.—Hughes, J. Hospital uses ward secre- taries to conserve time of nurses. Hosp. Management, 1942, 53: No. 5, 30.—Ibsen, M. M. Securing and maintaining competent administrative and other personnel for the small hospital. Bull. Am. Coll. Surgeons, 1941, 26: 57.—Information and instruction for the guidance of clinic clerks assigned to duty on the surgical service. Annual Rep. Minneapolis Gen. Hosp., 1933, 1: 141-60—Morrison, P. L. The nurse in hospital administration. Canad. Nurse, 1940, 36: 672-4. ---- Employment. Beecher, B. E. Sensible hiring. Mod. Hosp., 1939, 52: No. 3, 81.—Borowski, A. J. WPA workers and trainees in the hospital. Am. J. Nurs., 1941, 41: 1023-5.—Broadie, T. E. Selecting employees. Hospitals, 1938, 12: No. 8, 113.— Bugbce, G. P. Personnel problems with relation to civil service and government restrictions. Tr. Am. H sp. Ass., 1939, 11: 488 95.—Doane, J. C. High turnover of personnel; what can we do about it? Mod. Hosp., 1941, 57: No. 4, 51.— Erickson, E. I. PoUcies of employment. Tr. Am. Hosp. Ass., 1939, 41: 422-6. Also Hospitals, 1940, 14: No. 2, 71-3.— Fritschel, H. L. How unemployment insurance affects hos- pitals in Wisconsin; hospital employees are included in state's plan to provide income for workers losing employment through no fault of their own. Hosp. Management, 1835, 39: No. 1, 44.—Hamilton, J. A. An approach to the hospital personnel problem. Hosp. Topics, 1940, 18: 14-6.—Intendencia (La) reglament6 el ingreso en la carrera hospitalaria; requisites que debenin llenar los interesados; forma en que serAn provistos los distintos cargos. Dfa med., B. Air., 1933-34, 6: 980; 1000.— Legal decisions of interest to hospitals; legal aspects of selec- tion of the hospital staff. Hospitals, 1936, 10: No. 6, 106-10.— Longstaff, H. P. The selection and training of personnel Ibid., 1939, 13: No. 9, 53-8.—McCombs, C. E. Defects in civil service. Mod. Hosp., 1938, 50: 73-5.—Mohler, H. J. Enhghtened leadership needed to solve hospital employe problems. Hosp. Management, 1941, 52: No. 5. 21.—Mountin, J. W. Opportunities for service in the district hospital system' Puerto Rico Health Bull., 1940, 4: 335-43.—Persons, W. F. Uncle Sam supplies personnel. Mod. Hosp., 1938, 51: No. 6 61.—Pinner, M., & Weiss, M. Former patients on the pay roll. Ibid., 1941, 56: 71.—Reese, L. L. The National Youth Administration in government hospitals. Hospitals, 1941, 15: No. 5, 59-63.—Sch. Beschaftigung von Kranken in Kranken- hausern und Kliniken und Unfallversicherung. Zschr ges Krankenhauswes., 1941, 37: 137.—Walker, M. F. Problems in employment; a solution for small hospitals. Mod Hosn 1940, 55: No. 3, 61.—Walter. F. J. Labor turnover. Tr Am Hosp. Ass., 1939, 41: 431-40. ------ Survey of labor turn- over in hospitals. Hospitals, 1940, 14: No. 12, 84-6 Forensic aspect. Brosnan, L. J. Surgeon's responsibiUty for acts of hospital nurse. N. V ork State J. M., 1937, 37: 024-.V—Erinel. Zur Haftung eines Krankenhauses fiir seine Pflo<'esch wester HaftpflichtfaU. Rontgenpraxis, 1939, 11: 632.—Hayt E Hospital doctors cannot be subpoenaed. N York Physician 1934 3: No. 5, 15; 28—Le Sage. Indemnity aux medecins des hopitaux; mgdecins et ehomeurs. Union med Ca> ada 193o, 64: 845.—Lin, Hsin-Kwei. The status of hospital staff in legal proceedings; brief statement of law and procedure. Chin. M. J., 1938, 54: 283-7.—M. Haftung des Kranke^ hauses fiir Kunstfehler der Anstaltsarzte'' Zschr. ftrztl Fortbild., 1039, 36: 23. Malpractice; liability of attending physician for burns sustained in maternity homo. J. Am. M. Ass., 1940, 115: 1400.—Malpractice; liability of physician for unauthorized act of hospital nurse. Ibid., 1937, 109: 1665.— Montel, A. II tema di responsabilitd del medico e dell'ospedalc verso l'ammalato. Riv. crit. infortunist., 1933, 18: 104-9. - Pollet, L. Un aspect special de la responsabilit6 ini'-dicale- responsabilitd du m6decin d'hopital. Ann. m6d. lig., I9.JK. is- 432-8.—Practice of medicine bv incorporated hospitals J. Am. M. Ass., 1938, 110: 206B. UnfdlirolKen, der Arzt sollte schuld sein. Zschr. ges. Kraiikeulinuswes., 1941, 37; 177.—Whether hospital is Uable for negligence of employee iii performing tasks incident to his employment; Andrews vs Roosevelt Hospital et al., N. Y. S. 2d 447. Hospitals 1940 14- No. 8, 123. ' ' ---- Management. Agnew, H. PersonaUty and psychology in the hospital Hospitals, 1937, 11: No. 12, 23.—Anscombe, E. M. Personnel management. Ibid., No. 7, 40-3.—Application of 40 hour week to private hospitals [France] J. Am. M. Ass., 1937, 108: 1982.—Application in hospitals of 40 hour a week law [France! Ibid., 1938, 110: 521.—Augustine, G. M. Labor policies in hospitals. Ibid., 14: 309-29.—Bachmeyer, A. C. Personnel relations. Tr. Am. Hosp. Ass., 1937, 39: 355-64.----— An approach to the hospital personnel problem. J. Am. Diet. Ass., 1939, 15: 345-53. ------ Personnel policies in view of present conditions, with reference to selection, grading and dismissal. Hospitals, 1941, 15: No. 12, 16-9.—Barnes, H. S. Efficiency with reduced professional and technical personnel. Ibid., No. 4, 50-3.—Bluestone, E. M. A labor program for hospitals. Mod. Hosp., 1937, 48: No. 4, 43-5.—Boland, J. P. Labor relations in Catholic hospitals. Hosp. Progr., 1938, 19: 217-9.—Brady, H. M. The subsidiary worker; selection' duties, and contiol. Hospitals, 1940, 14: No. 4, 83.—Bran- ham, H. T. Personnel problems in the small hospital Ibid 1939, 13: No. 3, 91-3.—Burt, M. L. Employee schedules' Mod. Hosp., 1942, 58: 92.—Carter, F. G., Bush, J. F. [et al.j Report of the Committee on Nomenclature in Uniform Staff Organization, 1937. Tr. Am. Hosp. Ass., 1937, 39: 143-6.— Couch, R. Building esprit de corps. Hospitals, 1940, i4: No. 10, 80.—Crain, K. C. Better employe relations needed to reduce labor unrest in hospitals. Hosp. Management, 1941, 52: No. 2, 15. ------ Unionization and strikes confront hospitals in industrial areas. Ibid., 15-7.—Cullman, H. S. Relationship between hospital trustees and the medical staff' J. M. Soc. N. Jersey, 1934, 31: 30-4.—Dawson, W. A. Hos- pital courtesies to staff members. Hosp. Progr., 1939, 20: 394-6.—Doane, J. C. The hospital family; a study in adjust- ments. Mod. Hosp., 1936, 46: No. 5, 77-9. ------ Person- nel management. Bull. Am. Coll. Surgeons, 1939, 24: 181. ------ Staff problems of smaU hospitals. Mod. Hosp 1940, 54: No. 2, 81.—Emch, A. F. Hospital personnel policy. Hospitals, 1938, 12: No. 5, 43-5.—Emmons, E. V. Choose the right receptionist. Mod. Hosp., 1940, 55: No. 6. 55.—Franklin, J. B. What is your hospital doing'to improve efficiency by the routine training of personnel? Tr. Am, Hosp. Ass., 1931, 32: 198-203.—Frey, H. Zur Frage der Regiebetriebe und Arbeiter- ausschiisse in Krankenanstalten. Zschr. ges. Krankenhauswes. 1927, 23: 290-6—Golub. J. J. Revised staff rules end diffi- culties. Hosp. Management, 1926, 21: 35-8.—Goodwin, R. Q. Administration of cUnical clerkship. J. Ass. Am. M. Coll., 1934, 9: 229-35.—Gorgas, N. Three steps in management of personnel. Mod. Hosp., 1938, 51: No. 4, 43-6.—Hamilton, E. E. The integration of the hospital personnel as related to the needs of the patient. Hospitals, 1938, 12: No. 2, 89-92.— Hamilton, G. P. Insuring a competence for faithful hospital workers Ir. Am. Hosp. Ass., 1931, 33: 432-56.—Hamilton, «A* approach to the hospital personnel problem. Ibid., 1938, 40: 649-56. Also Hospitals, 1939, 13: No. 4 71-5 — Hanfeld, E. One or two shifts for the hospital chef? Rocky Mountain M. J., 1938, 35: 983.—Hewitt, S. R. D. House staff organization. Tr. Am. Hosp. Ass., 1937, 39: 879-97 — Hospitai efficiency impaired by 40 hours a week law [France] J. Am M. Ass., 1938, 110: 297—Hospitals for profit; right of State Labor Relations Board; o require collective bargaining. Ibid., 1941, 117: 473.—Hospitals not for profit; applicabiUty of Minnesota State Labor Relations act requiring collective bargaining with employees. Ibid., 474.—Hospitals not for profit; Pennsylvania State Labor Relations act requiring collective bargaining with employees not applicable. Ibid., 475.—Hospital strikes. Minnesota M., 1941 24- 680 — Hospital strike (Clipping from: Time, May 19, 1941)— Ladd, F. C. The control and assignment of duties of non- professional workers in the hospital. Bull. Am. Coll. Surgeons, 1942, 27: 38.—McDavitt. T. V. Courts and the unionization ot hospitai employees. J. Am. M. Ass., 1941, 117: 461-3.— McEachern, J. I). The merit system applied to the hospital staff. Canad. M. Ass. J., 1<*27. 17: 890-4.—Maphis, O. B. Maintaining adequate personnel in the small hospital. Hos- pitals, 1938, 12: No. 5, 91.—Marquis. La semaine de 40 heures dans les cliniques. Arch. med. chir. province, 1937. 27: 1<0—Morrill, W. P. Ratio of personnel to Ratients. Hos- pitals, 1940, 14: No. 1, 47-9.—Mourier. Sur 1'appUcation des 40 heures dans les hopitaux de Paris. Bull. Acad, med., Par., 1937, 3. ser., 118: 548-56.—Oehler, F. Die Methode und die I raxis der Zusammenarbeit von Verwaltung und Arat im HOSPITAL STAFF 859 HOSPITAL STAFF Krankenhaus. Nosokomeion, Stuttg., 1938, 9: 222-6.— O'Hanlon, G. Personnel management. Hospitals, 1939, 13: No. 5, 75-7.—Parnall, C. G. Sub-standard morale among hospital personnel. Diet. Admin. Ther., 1927, 5:117-9.—Pon- ton, T. R. Staff organization. Hosp. Management, 1937, 44: No. 4, 16.—Prentzel, H. T. Unions lose suit to organize Pennsylvania hospital employees. Ibid., 1941, 51: No. 2, 35.—Projet de convention collective entre les directions de cUniques privies, maisons de sant6, sanatoria prives et leur personnel. Bull. Min. san. pub., Par., 1936, 77-9.—Reinle, G. G. Hospital personnel problems from the standpoint of the private hospital. Hospitals, 1938, 12: No. 4, 33-6.— Scammell, H. M. Hospital personnel management from the standpoint of physical health. Ibid., No. 2, 93.—Schier, J., Ist Abdingbarkeit des Lohnanspruchs und automatisches Auflosen des Dienstverhaltnisses des Pfiege- und Hauspersonals bei Krankheit von langerer Dauer zulassig? Zschr. ges Krankenhauswes., 1928, 24: 375-7.—Sellier, H. Devois du personnel et discipline dans les 6tabUssements hospitaliers Rev. philanthr., Par., 1938, 54: 25-30.—Shepler, W. M. Open door policy in personnel relations. Mod. Hosp., 1938, 51: No. 2, 40-2.—Small hospital forum; medical staff and trustees, how they cooperate in 14 hospitals. Ibid., 1941, 57: No. 2, 61.—Strikes in hospitals. Hospitals, 1941, 15: No. 6, 68.— Talbot, W. B. Labor relations within the hospital. Ibid 1938, 12: No. 8, 53-6— Waas, F. J. Need of cooperation between the medical staff and the hospital governing body Ibid., 1940, 14: No. 4, 104.—Walker, M. F. Personnel prob- lems in smaU community hospital. Ibid., 1941, 15: No. 8, 94-6.—Walter, F. J. Personnel management in the hospital. Hosp. Management, 1937, 44: No. 6, 18; 48. ------ Na- tional events and their effect upon personnel relations. Bull. Am. Coll. Surgeons, 1942, 27: 28.—What hospitals are doing to improve employe morale. Mod. Hosp., 1941, 56: No. 6, 71.—Whitacre, H. J. The relationship of the governing board of a hospital to its medical staff. Tr. Am. Hosp. Ass., 1928, 30: 425-31.—Will, A. J. Personnel management. Hospitals, 1940, 14: No. 7, 94-8. ---- Medical staff. Ponton, T. R. The medical staff in the hos- pital. 288p. 25cm. Chic, 1939. Agnew, G. H. The doctor and his workshop. J. M. Soc. N. Jersey, 1939, 36: 424-7.—Alcock, S. C. The future staffing of hospitals. Lancet, Lond., 1942, 1: 239.—Alezias, H. Les adjoints des hopitaux. MarseiUe mid., 1937, 74: pt 2, 173; 313; 365.—Ankeny, A. F. What the nurse expects of the doctor. Hospitals, 1936, 10: 77-9.—Arnold, T. The hospital and its medical staff. Mod. Hosp., 1938, 51: No. 4, 55.— Bachmeyer, A. C. Selecting and organizing the medical staff. Ibid., 1934, 42: 59-62.—Bager, B. [Education and appoint- ment of hospital physicians] Sven. lak. tidn., 1936, 33: 529- 38.—Baldassari, L. Per la preparazione del personale medico direttivo degU ospedaU. Igiene mod., 1933, 26: 81-4.— Ballmann, E. Die arztUche Organisation des Deutschen Krankenhauses. Zschr. ges. Krankenhauswes., 1926, 22: 75-7.—Barnes, S. J. We control our medical staff. Mod. Hosp., 1941, 56: No. 5, 67.—Baumgartner, L. In-service training for doctors and nurses. Am. J. Pub. Health, 1939, 29: 597-602.—Berenice, M. Medical staff constitutions. Hosp. Progr., 1937, 18: 302.—Bishop, H. M. A surgeon looks at the smaU hospital staff. Mod. Hosp., 1940, 55: No. 4, 51.— Bluestone, E. M. Condescendin;; staff men. Ibid., 1936, 46: No. 2, 75.—Bonnenfant, M. Les relations entre l'administra- tion et les medecins d'un hopital frangais, d'apres le point de vue des administrateurs et de3 medecins. Nosokomeion, Stuttg., 1938, 9: 121-8.—Brown, L. P., & Dickinson, A. M. A plan for judging quaUfication3 of appUcants for hospital privileges. BuU. Am. Coll. Surgeons, 1937, 22: 242.—Cahal, M. F. The employment of physicians by hospitals; some legal aspects. Am. J. Roentg., 1941, 46: 271; 416; passim. Also Connecticut M. J., 1942, 6: 292-300. Also Radiology, 1941, 37: 237; passim.—Carcamo Lardizabal, M. El medico noso- comial. Labor med., Mex., 1941, 9: 65.—Cernadas, P. V. Carrera medica hospitalaria. Sem. med., B. Air., 1934, 41: pt 2, 350.—Clemmesen, C. |Young physician's forum; chairman's report on May 7th, 1936] Ugeskr. laeger, 1936, 98: 403.—Curtis, G. W. The organized medical staff in the smaU hospital. Tr. Am. Hosp. Ass., 1927, 29: 316-30 — Employment of aUen doctors in hospitals. Brit. M. J., 1941, 1: Suppl., 38.—Employment (Ths) in hospitals of alien phy- sicians and nurses [England] J. Am. M. Ass., 1941, 116: 155.—Foote, M. N. Responsibi lity of the medical staff in maintaining control and quality of the professional work in the hospital. Bull. Am. CoU. (Surgeons, 1942, 27: 26-8 — From a hospital physician. Lanost, Lond., 1938, 1: 458-60.— Golub, J. J. Shifting the emphasis from departmental to functional organization of medical staff; a departure from a commonly accepted pattern of staff organization for medico- administrative purposes. Hospitals, 1940, 14: No. 10, 108- 15.—Gouachon. A. Le recrutement des medecins dans les hopitaux frangais et l'etendue de leurs fonctions. Noso- komeion, Stuttg., 1931, 2: 29-59— Hatch, A. In a small hospital; organizing the medical staff. Mod. Hosp., 1935, 45: No. 1, 53.—Haywood, A. K. Further observations on the open, closed, or restricted professional staff. Tr. Am. Hosp. Ass., 1933, 35: 583-7. Also BuU. Am. Hosp. Ass., 1934 8: 85-90,—Hermann, K. [Hospital appointments and quakfica- ™0nf] Ugeskr. laeger, 1940, 102: 1277—Hewitt, S R D Medical house staff organization. Hospitals, 1937, 11: No* ll' Brit M T7ori9' V' nu,ii uicuiuai ue in one- Dame pour 1935; reve et reality Ibid., 407-9.—Martin, F. H. Hospitals and the staff; economics of the healing art Diplo- mate, Phila., 1933, 5: 191-6.—May, A. J. The hospital and doctor [poem] In his A Basket of Fragments, N. Y. 1939 136-41.—Moreno, M. El externado y el internado de los hospitales de Pans; comentario a la carta del Dr Braine. Rev Fac. med., Bogotd, 1938-39, 7: 445-51.—Organized and courtesy staffs of general hospitals; a study by the Council on medical education and hospitals of the American Medical Association with the cooperation of the council of the American hospital association. J. Am. M. Ass., 1935, 105: 741.— Piazza, F. ResponsibiUties of an executive physician in a municipal hospital out-patient department. Hospitals, 1940, 14: No. 9, 48-52.—Piatt, H. The future staffing of hospitals. Lancet, Lond., 1942, 1: 179.—Ponton, T. R. The hospital and its medical staff. Hosp. Management, 1937, 44: N .. 3, 14. ------■ Appraisal of the work of individual physicians. Ibid., 1938, 45: No. 2, 14.—Principes de deontologie. Presse med., 1938, 46: 1869.—Reglement de l'externat de l'Hopital de la Charite. J. sc. med. Lille, 1924, 42: pt 1, 357-62.— Regulations on the appointment of hospital physicians [Buenos Aires] J. Am. M. Ass., 1940, 115: 547.—Repartition des chefs de service, des chefs de cUnique, des internes et externes. Gaz. hop., 1936, 109: 693-701.—Schlayer. Die Wahl des Kranken- hausarztes. Zschr. ges. Krankenhauswes., 1934, 313.— Shrader, E. L. Designation of medical-staff rank. Hosp. Progr., 1933, 14: 338-41— Sister Mary Carolyn. Stabilizing the graduate staff. Bocky Mountain M. J., 1940, 37: 350-2.— Sittmann, G. Krankenhauspflegling und Krankenhausarzt. Munch, med. Wschr., 1934, 81: 663-5.—Situation (La) des externes des hopitaux de Paris. Bull, mid., Par., 1924, 14: 95.—Slagle, C. E. The medical staff of the small hospital. Hospitals, 1941, 15: No. 5, 31-3.—Sollazzo, G. Rapporti del medico con gU altri servizi deU'ospedale. Gior. Soc. ital. igiene, 1935, 57: 185-93.—Sotolongo, F. El lamentable accidente del Hospital de C&rdenas. Med. d. hoy, Habana, 1939, 4: 154.—Steinwallner. Neues iiber die Arzneiversorgung in schwedischen Krankenanstalten. Zschr. ges. Kranken- hauswes., 1938, 429.—Tenopyr, J. The responsibility of the medical staff in the administration of the hospital. Bull. Am. CoU. Surgeons, 1930, 14: 38.—Twist, E. A. The increasing responsibilities of the hospital's medical staff. Hosp. Progr., 1938 19: 330-3.—Walker, E. The importance of an efficient medical staff. Hospitals, 1940, 14: No. 2, 107-10. ------ Andersen, O. N. [et al.] The medical staff; its organization and function. Bull. Am. Coll. Surgeons, 1940, 25: 76-82.— Wartime estabhshment of house posts. Brit. M. J., 1940, 2: Suppl 7 —Weber, H. Der Krankenhausarzt und die deutsche Aerzteschaft. Med. Welt, 1932, 6: 905.—White, C. G. P.'s on hospital staffs? Yes! Med. Econom., 1940-41, 18: No. 8. 52-5.—Wright, H. J. The smaU hospital and its medical staff relationships. Mod. Hosp., 1934, 43: 45-8.—Zapffe, F C. The resident medical staff; sectional meeting of C. H. A. convention. Hosp. Progr., 1937, 18: 304-12. ---- Medical staff: Conferences. Agnew, G. H. SmaU hospitals round table. Tr. Am. Hosp Ass., 1936, 38: 524-30.—Anido, V. Nuestras sesiones cienti- ficas. Bol. mens. cUn. As. Damas La Covadonga, 1934, 6: 76-9.—Christian, H. A. Some missed pedagogic opportunities incident to the usual organization of the resident staff of a hospital. Bull. Am. Coll. Surgeons, 1929, 13: 19-22.—Davis, R B. How hospital staff meetings can be made successful. South. M. & S., 1940, 102: 579.— Fitz, R. Importance of clinical-pathologic conferences in work of the practitioner as teacher. J. Am. M. Ass., 1933, 101: 253-5—Foss, H. L. The medical staff conference. Hospitals, 1938, 12: No. 3, 85.— Larsen N P. The conduct of a hospital staff conference. Proc. Panpacific Surg. Conf., 1929, 1. Conf., 216-9—McNa- mara F P Clinicopathologic conferences are vital in small hospitals". Mod. Hosp., 1934, 42: 61-4.—Nix, J. T. Proper attitude of the medical staff towards the medical staff con- ference. Hospitals, 1938, 12: No. 3, 99—Parnall, C. G., & Cloueh H D Visual methods in conducting the staff con- ference! Bull. Am. Coll. Surgeons, 1929, 13: 3-18—Piersol. G M. Staff conferences; general and. departmental, and the relations between internal medicine and other cUnical services. Ibid 1926, 10: No. 2, 35-9.—Reunioes mensais de estudos nos hospitals da assistencia municipal. Rev. med. mun., Rio 1941 l- 274- 580.—Sesiones anatomo-chmcas del Hos- pital Ramos Mejia. Acci6n med., B. Air., 1940 10: 291 — Skvotsov M. A. [Importance of chmco-anatomical conferences as obUga'tory part of hospital life] Vrach. delo, 1936, 19: HOSPITAL STAFF 860 HOSPITAL STAFF 667-72.— Sladen, K. J. The hospital staff conference; essentials in a staff conference approved for hospitals. Proc. Ann. Congr. M. Educ, 1929, 51-5. Also J. Am. M. Ass., 1929, 92: 1573-5.—-Spitz. H. The pathological conference in well regulated hospitals. BuU. Am. Coll. Surgeons, 1926, 10: No. 2, 41-4.—Thomson, H. C. The Middlesex Hospital Medical Society. Med. Press & Circ, Dubl., 1937, 194: 310-3. ---- Medical staff: Residence. Holderness, G. S. Doctors' quarters. Mod. Hosp., 1942, 58: No. 3, 55--7, plans. — Pohlenz, C. Notwendige Vorausset- zungen fiir die Wohnverhaltnisse beim Anstaltspersonal. Zschr. ges. Krankenhauswes., 1938, 68-70. ---- Medical staff: Visiting staff. Bengs, H. A., Harris, G. R. [et al.] Employment of outside ph\si(ians to conduct lay-operated clinics. Pennsylvania M. .!., 1940—41, 44: 1676.—Gli assistenti universitari volontari ed il regolamento ospedaUero. Rass. internaz. cUn. ter., 1940, 21: 121.—Kogel, M. D. A plan for instruction for junior members of the medical visiting staff. Hospitals, 1939, 13: 88. ---- Salary. Circulaire du 28 septembre 1936 k MM. les Pr6fets sur le ehoix et la remuneration des medecins des hopitaux et des hospiees. Bull. Min. san. pub., Par., 1936, 79.—Clarke, F. K. S. Salaries of hospital pharmacists. Pharm. J., Lond., 1941, 93: 158.- Control (A) experiment wanted. Nurs. Times, Lond., 1940, 36: 847.—Hatfield. J. N. Methods of wage compensation, including perquisites. Tr. Am. Hosp. Ass., 1939, 41: 426-31. Also Hospitals, 1940, 14: No. 2, 115- 7.—Hospital staff contributes share of income to members on active military duty. J. Am. M. Ass., 1941, 116: 1780.— Jensen, A. C. Food or cash for employees. Mod. Hosp., 1941, 57: No. 5, 84.—Lopez Rovirosa, G. Beneficiar a los medicos, enfermeras, alumnos y empleados que atienden ciertas enfermedades, es necesario. Arch, hosp., Habana, 1940, 11: 239.—Mills, A. B. Hospital salaries; superintendents of nurses. Mod. Hosp., 1940, 54: No. 6, 52. ------ Hospital salaries; dietitians. Ibid., 55: No. 1, 50. ------ Hospital salaries; housekeepers. Ibid., No. 2, 44. ------ Hospital salaries; engineers. Ibid., No. 3, 54.------Hospital sal- aries; pharmacists. Ibid., No. 4, 58. ------ A national study of salaries; orderUes and ward aids. Ibid., 1941, 56: No. 3, 47. ------ Accountants and bookkeepers; a study of salaries. Ibid., 57: No. 3, 69. ------ Chefs and chief cooks; a national study of salaries. Ibid., 45. ------ Laundry managers and workers; a national study of salaries. Ibid., No. 4, 81.—Norton, M. T. Wages and hours bill does not affect hospitals. Hospitals, 1938, 12: No. 6, 17.—Oseroff, A. Salaries, wages and personnel relations. Bull. Am. Coll. Surgeons, 1942, 27: 48.—Peck, J. F., jr. A step towards personnel salary -tandardization. Hospitals, 1941, 15: No. 6, 80-7.—Pennell, K. H., Mountin, J. W., & Hankla, E. Sum- mary figures on income, expenditures, and personnel of hos- pitals. Ibid.. 1938, 12: Xo. 4, 11-9.—Place, E. L. Hospitals should study their wage plans. Ibid., 1941, 15: No. 10, 61.— Projector. H., & De Sanctis, A. G. Should cUnic doctors be paid' Med. Econom., 1940-41, 18: No. 4, 48.—Remuneration (l'he) of medical stalls of voluntary hospitals. Brit. J. Ophth., 193S, 22: 230-2.—Salaries of hospital personnel, 1940. In Hosp. Yoaib.. 1941, 19: 1003-10.—Wage adjustment and training urged at section on personnel. Hosp. Management, 1941, 52: No. 4, 28.—Wuth, K. Die Umsatzsteuer fur die Behandlunsrsgelder der Krankenhausarzte. Deut. med. Wschr., 1940, 66: 746. ---- Services for employees. Blumensaat. Versicherung des medizinischen Personals der stadtischen Krankenhauser gegen berufliche UnfaUe in Paris. Aerztl. Mitt., Lpz.. 1928, 29: 1000.—Couteaux, J. Pour le personnel des hopitaux. Rev. philanthrop., Par., 1937, 53: 237-45.—Dana, M. G. Feeding of hospital employees. Hos- pitals, 1938, 12: No. 4, 59-63.—Eck, E. Cafeteria service for personnel. Tr. Am. Hosp. Ass., 1936, 38: 363-8. ------■ A hospital cafeteria. J. Am. Diet. Ass., 1938, 14: 99-108.— Eckert, A. W. Safeguarding personnel. Mod. Hosp., 1940, 54: No. 0. 43.—Erikson, C. A., & McCIeery, A. B. Evanston Hospital provides for its domestic help. Ibid., 1926, 27: No. 6, 51-3.—Frankel, L. K., jr. Protecting your employees. Ibid., 1935. 45: No. 4, 57-9.—Harrington, M. M. InstalUng a pay cafeteria for personnel. Hospitals, 1942, 16: No. 2, 90-2.— Hayhow, E. C. Pension and life insurance plans for hospital employees. Hospitals, 1940, 14: No. 11, 73-7.—Hill, F. T. Continuation education for hospital staff. Ibid., 1941, 15: No. 6, 37-9.—Hines, M. L. Satisfaction and economy in personnel feeding. Tr. Am. Hosp. Ass., 1938, 40: 168-76. Also Hospitals. 1938, 12: No. 10, 112.—Jarrett, L. E. What the hospital should do for the house staff. Ibid., 1937, 11: No. 7, 98-100.—Lemcke, H. Here employes may play. Mod. Hosp., 1941, 56: 53. Locke, B. B. Emplovees' retirement plan Hospital-. 193s. 12: No. 7, 34-7.—Mariette, E. S., & Jennings, F. L. Planned health service for employees iu tuberculosis sanatoria. Ibid., 1937, 21: No. 7, 32-9.—Masoner, K. W. Senator Wagner introduces new biU to amend Social Security Act. Hosp. Management, 1910, 50: No. 3, 30.- Neff, H. E. Employee health service. Tr. Am. Hosp. Ass., 1939, 41: los 16. Also Hospitals, 1940, 14: No. 1, 40-3.--- To protect employe health and safeguard hospital interests. Mod. Hosp., 1941, 57: 74. New (The) agreement with the I'uited States Employees' Compensation Commission. Hosp. Progr.. 1912, 23: 60-3.—Norby, J. G. Health service for hospital personnel' Bull. Am. CoU. Surgeons, 1942, 27: 36.- O Hanlon. G. Health programs for nurses and employees. Bull. Am. Hosp. Ass 1935, 9: 112-8.—Orosa, S. Y. The share privilege of physicians serving in government provincial hospitals. ,J. Philippine Islands M. Ass., 1934, 14: 48.5-9. -Reeves, J. Help for the hospital staff. Med. Econom., 1938-39, 16: No. 12, 40-2 — Roentgenologist (The) the pathologist and the anesthetist under hospital insurance plans. J. Am. M. Ass., 1938, 111: 158.—Rubenstein, I. H. Hospital employees and workmen's compensation. Hosp. Management, 1937, 44: No. 6, 21; 54 — Shepler, W. M., Koch, E. G, & Hamilton, J. A. Standardized training course for ward aids. Mod. Hosp., 1938, 51: No. 6, (>."> -72.—Social Security for hospital personnel waits on < 'ongress Hosp. Management, 1942, 53: No. 2, 31.- -Swift, <;. W. Basic considerations in the extension of hospital privileges to the medical staff. Proc. Panpacific Surg. Conf., 1929, 1. Conf., 214.—Systematic medical supervision of medical students and nurses. Lancet, Lond., 1934, 2: 509. -Training hospital attend- ants. Med. Rec. N. Y., 1941, 153: 455.—Troutt, L. I'a\ cafeteria for personnel. Hospitals, 1942, 16: No. 4, 52-4.- Vacation and sick leave practices in Virginia and North Caro- lina. In Hosp. Admin. & Org. (Hosp. Management) Chic, 1942, 144.—Wellman, R. Social security for hospital workers. Hospitals, 1937, 11: No. 7, 16-9.—Wells, E. Cafeteria meets hospital need. Mod. Hosp., 1920, 14: 60.—Whittemore, C. I,. A year's experience in employee health service. Ibid., 1942, 58: No. 5, 71.—Wilson, L. R. Health examinations for hospital employees. Tr. Am. Hosp. Ass., 1938, 40: 180-3. Also Hospi- tals, 1939, 13: No. 3, 29.—Zappe. Die Angestelltenversichc- rungspflicht des Krankenhauspersonals. Zschr. ges. Kranken- hauswes., 1938, 118-20. ---- Technical staff. Approval of hospitals in reference to type of technician training. Gradwohl Lab. Digest, 1940-41, 4: No. 10, 1.— Gray, W. Cooperation of hospital pharmacist and staff. J. Am. M. Ass., 1930, 94: 1283. Also repr.—Herzog, J. H. The hospital engineer. Hospitals, 1938, 12: No. 4, 57.—Iribarne, J. El personal t6cnico; reclutamiento y escalaf6n. Rev. As. mid. argent., 1933, 46: 2271-3.—Sister M. Liguori. Health service for nurses and other personnel. Hospitals, 1941, 15: No. 8, 50-2. ---- Uniform. Bryan, M. DeG. Maybe it's the uniform. Mod. Hosp., 1941, 57: No. 6, 90-4.—Cunningham, R. M., jr. Specialists in plain clothes. Hygeia, Chic, 1941, 19: 385.—Harmsen, H. Berufs- und Schutzkleidung in Krankenanstalten. Zbl. Gewer- behyg., 1939, Beih. 28, 131-7.—Sloan, R. P. Service stripes for hospital women. Mod. Hosp., 1938, 51: No. 3, 56-9. HOSPITALSTIDENDE. Kbh., v.1-81, 1893- 1938. Continued in Nordisk medicin. Jarl0v, E., & Mogensen, E. (Hospitalstidende; in the past, present and future] Hospitalstidende, 1938, 81: 1209-17. HOSPITAL survey for New York. See New York. United Hospital Fund. Survey Committee. Study Committee. Report of the hospital survey for New York. 3v. 8? N. Y., 1937-38. HOSPITAL topics and buyer; the friendly hospital journal. Chic, 111., v. 15, No. 4, 1937- HOSPITALS (The) year-book; an annual record of the hospitals of Great Britain and Ireland, incorporating Burdett's hospitals & charities, 1931-36; 1940. 5v. tab. 29cm. Lond., Nurs. Mirror, 1931-40. HOSPITAL train [incl. mobile units] Army medical equipment. Mil. Surgeon, 1942, 90: 588.— Chappotin y Diaz, M., & Muniz Angtilo, L. Hospitaler auf Radern. Deut. MiUtiirarzt, 1940, 5: 503 (Abstr.) (microfilm)— Dost, O. Lazarettziige in verschiedenen Staaten. Ibid., 1939, 4: 521-5.—First mobile hospital unit serves entire county. Hosp. Management, 1940, 49: No. 3, 20. Also in Hosp. Admin. & Org. (Hosp. Management) Chic, 1942, 121.—Grill, J. A hospital on wheels. Memphis M. J., 1936, 11: 21; 30 — Hamilton, A. G. A hospital goes to the people. CUn. M. & S., 1939, 46: 178.—Hospital (El) m6vil de Torquemada. Cruz roja, Madr., 1932, 34: 732-8.—Hospitals on wheels. Ho.-p. Topics, 1942, 20: 12-4.—Large mobile hospital shipped by XavytoCuba. Science News Lett., 1940,38:215.—McWhirtes, J. The mobile A. R. P. hospital unit. Brit. M. J., 1940, 1: 744.—Trailer clinics are expected to be practical in the health work; Edgecombe's traveling cUnic. Health Bull., Raleigh, 1940, 55: No. 10, 1.—West, J. B. New mobUe unit takes HOSPITAL TRAIN 861 HOTEL surgical station to scene of disaster; unique hospital on wheels is designed to cope with both army and civilian emergency needs. Hosp. Management, 1942, 53: No. 2, 23.—Wilson. F. E. Edgecombe's traveling cUnic Health Bull., Raleigh, 1940, 55: No. 10, 11-3. HOSPITAL (The) world, Toronto, Can., v.23, Nos. 1, 2, 1923. HOSPITAL (The) yearbook; a reference book on planning, equipment, administration and purchasing [13. ed.] 1 p. 1. xii, 543p. incl. illust. tab. 29cm. Chic, Modern Hosp. pub. co., 1934. Also 17. ed. 1 p. 1. 801p. 29^cm. 1939. Also 19. ed. 2 p. 1. 1028p. 29#cm. 1941. HOSS, Kate, 1903- *Maternitatstetanie; mit Bericht iiber einen einschlagigen Fall aus der Krankenanstalt des Bayerischen Landesvereins vom Roten Kreuz, Munchen [Munchen] 16p. 8? Diisseld., G. H. Nolte, 1934. HOSSEIN, Cheybani, 1902- ♦Contribu- tion a l'etude clinique du mal de garrot chez le cheval [Alfort] 76p. 8? Par., Vigot freres, 1932. HOSSENFELDER, Friedrich, 1908- *Eignet sich die Blutserumprazipitation fiir die Galtdiagnose beim Rind? [Munchen] 27p. tab. 21cm. Marquartstein, Hohenhaus, 1937. HOSSFELD, Ernst, 1912- *Kritik der Schlusselstiickabdruckmethode auf Grund eigener klinischer Erfahrungen [Munchen] 20p. 8? Diisseld., G. H. Xolte, 1934. HOSSFELD, Gunther, 1912- *Kiefer- verletzungen nach Zahnextraktionen und ihre schadensrechtliche Bedeutung [Munchen] 16p. 8° Wurzb., R. Mayr, 1937. HOSSMANN, Eva, 1904- *Canthariden- reaktion und mensueller Zyklus; ein Beitrag zur Prufung der unspezifischen Allergie [Breslau] p.38-50. 8? Berl., J. Springer, 1929. Also Arch. Gyn., Berl., 1929-30, 139: HOSTE, Hans. Editor of: Gesundheit und Erziehung. Lpz., v.46, 1933- HOSTEING, Jean Maurice Joseph, 1885- *Contribution a l'etude de l'omoplate scaphoide et de ses connexions pathologiques. 75p. 8: Bord., Impr. Barthelemy & Cledes, 1913. HOSTILITY. Fromm-Reichmann, F. Psychoanalytical remarks on the cUnical significance of hostiUty. Med. Ann. District of Colum- bia, 1936, 5: 260-3. HOSTMANN, Jeannot. See Sadtler, Samuel Philip, Coblentz, V., & Hostmann, J. Pharmaceutical & medical chemistry. 6. ed. 748p. 8? Phila., [19271 For portrait see CoU. Pharm. N. York (Wimmer, C. P.) N. Y., 1929, 92. HOTALING, Elmer E. See Ryer, E. L., & Hotaling, E. E. Optometric procedure, basic and supplementary. 94p. 2ZViem. [N. Y., 1941] HOTCHKISS, Lucius Wales, 1860-1926. Obituary. J. Am. M. Ass., 1926, 86: 1467. HOTEL. American hotel directory; 1917 ed. 959p. 24cm. Wash., 1917. . Bohrmann, P. *Studie iiber die Krankheits- und Sterblichkeitsverhaltnisse im Gasthausge- werbe [Leipzig] 26p. 8? Zeulenroda l. Thiir., 1932. Massachusetts. State Board of Health, Lunacy and Charity. Circular of the health department [to secure information, with regard to disease caused by bad sanitary arrangements in country hotels and boarding houses (October, 1879] Boston, 1879. . Wing, A., & Wing, J. Knapsacks aweign; last year 243 American youths hostels in 9 sec- tions of the United States offered overnight hospitality to nearly 14,000 hikers and bikers p.21-4. 22}/2cm. (CUpping from: Scribner's Commentator, September, 1941) .runordnune, der Abort- und Baderaume in Hotelbauten' Milderung der seuchenpoUzeilichen Massnahmen gegen Liipnthene und Scharlach insbesondere im Sinne einer Abschaf- f ung beziehungsweise Einschrankung der Wohnungsdesinfektion. Veroff. Medverwalt., 1930, 32: 695-764.—Cyr, R. Sanitary problems of hostelry. Bull, san., Montreal, 1942, 42: 13-23.— Daguin, F. L'hygiene dans l'industrie hoteUere. Techn. san mun., Par., 1937, 32: 295-310.—Dombrowsky, K. H. Zur Gaststattenhygiene. Arch. Hyg., Miinch., 1935, 114: 89-92.— Luders, E. Der Arbeitsschutz im Gast- und Schankwirkschafts- gewerbe. Arbeiterschutz, Berl., 1929, 12.—Perkins, J. V. Home-saving through housekeeper service. Child, Wash., 1940, 5: 100-3.—Rules and regulations governing rooming houses, lodging houses and hotels. Baltimore Health News, 1942, 19: 28-31.—Shakley, H. Health department in an hotel. Nurs. J. China, 1941, 64-8. HOTH, Fritz, 1904- *Kohlehydratstoff- wechsel und Ovarium; ein Beitrag zur Physiologie des Ovariums. 31p. 8? Kiel [n. pub.] 1927. HOTOP, Hans, 1909- *Vergleichende Untersuchungen uber den Gehalt verschiedener Tierhypophysen an Melanophoren- und Ery- throphorenhormon [Rostock] 15p. 8? Guters- loh, Thiele [1934-35] HOTOP, Kate, 1907- *Ueber Adipositas dolorosa [Rostock] 32p. 8? Dillingen a. D., Schwab. Verlagsdr., 1934. HOTOP, Lotte, 1905- *Drei Falle von hamolytischem Ikterus [Wurzburg] 22p. 8? Dillingen a. D., Schwab. Verlagsdr., 1931. HOT Springs, Ark. Barry Hospital. Annual reports. Hot Springs, v.1-2, 1890-91. HOTTENROTH, Hans, 1912- *Ein Beitrag zur Osler'schen Erkrankung. 23p. 21cm. [Frankf. a. M., n. pub., 1938] HOTTENROTH, Kurt, 1908- *Beitrage zur Ueberfiihrung von Azofarbstoffen in Kiipen- farbstoffe der a-Naphthochinonreihe. 39p. 22#cm. Heidelb., J. Horning, 1936. HOTTINGER, Adolf, 1897- *Ueber- tragungsversuche von Spiilwasser aus Nasen- rachenraum Grippekranker auf Kaninchen; allge- meine Bemerkungen iiber Blut- und Lungen- veranderungen bei Experimenten an diesen Tieren [Basel] p.454-80. 8? Berl., J. Springer, 1923 Also Zschr. ges. exp. Med., 1923, 37: ---- Ueber die Aufzucht friihgeborener Kinder im Basler Kinderspital und deren Ergeb- nisse von 1922 bis 1927 mit besonderer Beruck- sichtigung der Fruhgeburtenrachitis. 135p. 8? Berl., S. Karger, 1928. Forms H. 20, Abh. Kinderh. ----Epidemiologisches iiber die Tuberkulose im Kindesalter. 26p. 8? Lpz., J. A. Barth, 1931. Forms H. 44, Tuberk. Biblioth. ---- Ueber die maligne, sogenannte toxische Diphtherie (epidemiologische, klinische und ex- perimentelle Beitrage) 88p. 8? Berl., S. Karger 1932. Forms H. 31, Abh. Kinderh. HOTZ, August, 1887- *Die pulsdyna- mischen Untersuchungsmethoden und ihre kli- nische Anwendung; mit besonderer Beruck- sichtigung des Kindesalters [Zurich] 74p. 8°. Berl., J. Springer [1923] Also Zschr. ges. exp. Med., 1923, 37: HOTZ, Gerhard, 1880-1926. Bircher. Nekrolog. Beitr. kUn. Chir., 1927, 140: 373 — Curriculum vitae; geschrieben in den schwersten Krankheits- tagen Marz-April 1926. Schweiz. med Wschr., 1926 56: 672-4—Enderlen. Nekrolog. Deut. med. Wschr., 192b, 52: 1181 Also Klin. Wschr., 1926, 5: 1255. Also Schweiz med. Wschr 1926, 56: 674.—Florcken, H. Nekrolog. Munch. med Wschr., 1926, 73: 1117.—Krafft, H. C. Necrologie. Rev. HOTZ 862 HOUGH med. Suisse rom., 1926, 46: 514.—Nekrolog. Beitr. klin. Chir., 1926, 137: TI. 2.—Obituary. Lancet, Lond., 1926, 1: 1231 — Redwitz, E. von. Nekrolog. Med. Klin., Berl., 1926, 22: 1168. HOTZ, Heinrich W., 1907- *Die Chole- cvstographie [Zurich] 50p. 8? Wien, B. Baitolt, 1933. HOTZ, Rudolf, 1905- *Zur Frage der Kiefernekrosen. 34p. 8? Ziir., Buchdr. Bericht- haus, 1932. Also Schweiz. Mschr. Zahnh., 1932, 42: HOTZ, Trudel, 1903- *Die Osteodys- trophia fibrosa und ihre Beziehungen zum endo- krinen System [Heidelberg] 31 p. 8? Walldorf, F. Lamade, 1930. HOTZE, C. L. First lessons in physiology for use in the common schools. 204p. 12? S. Louis, Am. school book co., 1897. ---- Lessons in anatomy, physiology, and hygiene, viii, 384p. 12? S. Louis, Becktold print. & book co., 1897. HOTZ-JENNY, Margerit, 1911- *Die akute und chronische Kohlenoxyd vergiftung; statistische Arbeit auf Grund des Materials der SUVA aus den Jahren 1930-34. 46p. 21cm. Ziir., Buchdr. Berichthaus, 1938. HOUBEN [Heinrich Hubert Maria] Joseph, 1875- Fortschritte der Heilstoffchemie. 2. Abt.: Die Ergebnisse der wissenschaftlichen Literature. 2. Bd: Die aromatischen Verbin- dungen. xxxi, 1056p. 8? Berl., W. de Gruyter & Co., 1932. HOUCKE, Emile. La rate en pathologie sanguine. 154p. 2 1. 8? Par., Masson & cie, 1936. HOUDA, Emilian Otto, 1879- Conquest of goiter. 157p. pl. portr. 16? [Tacoma, Wash., Conrad print, co., 1936] HOUDART, Raymond, 1913- *R61e du service social dans les services hospitaliers de m6decine infantile. 48p. 24>£cm. Par., M. Vigne. 1939. HOUDECEK, Eugen Emanuel, 1904- *Sepsis nach Angina [Zurich] p.317-406. 24>:;_' •">.—Joannon, P. Remarques sur le decret-loi du 24 mail 1938 relatif aux immeubles insalubres. Ann. hyg., Par., 1938, n. ser., 16: 381-405.—Kriiger. Der Entwurf eines preus- sischen Studtebaugesetzes. Soziale Prax., 1926, 35: 146; 178.— Landsberger, J. Die hygienischen Grundlagen zum preus- sischen Wohnungsgesetz. Med. Klin., Berl., 1904-5, 1: i68.— Lloyd, M. G. Housing codes; preliminary report of the sub- committee on housing codes, Committee on the Hygiene of Housing. In Housing for Health (Am. Pub. Health Ass.) Lancaster. 1941, 48-53. Also Am. J. Pub. Health, 1942, 32: No. 3, Suppl., 62-5.—Nuove (Le) norme tecniche per l'edilizia; il testo del decreto-legge. Riv. internaz. ingegn. san., 1938, 6: 41 -50.—Paul, H. The Housing Act, 1930. Pub. Health, Lond., 1934, 47: 284-7.—Peirson, T. The contribution of recent housing legislation to public health. J. State M., Lond., 1937, 45: 397-403.—Resolucion sobre permiso sanitario para ocupar inmuebles. Rev. san., Caracas, 1940, 5: No. 2, 304.—Rules and regulations governing the hygiene of housing. Baltimore Health News, 1942, 19: 25-7—Souza Pinheiro, H. de. Modi- ficacoes na legislacao sanitaria do estado de S. Paulo para barateamento das edificacoes populares, sem prejufzo da higiene. Arq. hig., S. Paulo, 1940, 5: No. 10, 111-9.—Stans- burv, C. A. The Housing Act, 1930: promise and performance. J. H. San. Inst., 1934-35, 55: 619-32.—Swift, S. Overcrowding and the Housing Act, 1935. Ibid., 1936-37, 57: 465-77.— Tangye. C. E., Maplcton, H. B., & Redfern, A. J. The Housing (Rural Workers) Act. Ibid.. 1927-28, 48: 14-21.—Vaughan, H. F. Public health standards in housing. Proc. Milbank Mem. Fund., 1940, 18: 9-21.— Webster, H. Ministry of health model byelaws (series IV) buildings, the problem of revision of existing bvelaws. J. R. San. Inst., 1938-39, 59: 640-51.— Wheeler, J. S. The Housing Act, 1935. Ibid., 1935-36, 56: ■12."> 31. ---- Medical aspect. See also Group, Disease. Allhoff, K. *Die sozialen, wirtschaftlichen und Wohnungsverhiiltnisse in der Stadt Munster und ihre Beziehungen zum Verlauf der Erkran- kungs- und Sterbefalle an Scharlach und Diph- theric, 1912-30 [Munster] 35p. 22cm. [Balve i. W.] 1933. Bohl, A. J. What housing means to health. Pennsylvania Health, 1935, 13: No. 5, 21 -5.—Britten, R. H. The relation between housing and health. Pub. Health Rep., Wash., 1934, 49: 1301-13. ------ Housing and health. Am. J. Pub. Health, 1938, 28: 957-60. ------ & Altman, I. Illness and accidents among persons living under different housing condi- tions. Pub. Health Rep., Wash., 1941, 56: 609-40. ------& Brown, J. E. Certain characteristics of urban housing and their relation to illness and accidents: summary of findings of the National health survey. Milbank Mem. Fund Q., 1940, 18: 91-113. Also in Housing for Health (Am. Pub. Health Ass.) Lancaster, 1941, 159-S1.—Chalmers, A. K. National death- rates in relation to national differences in methods of housing. Proc. R. Soc. M., Lond., 1925-26, 19: Sect. Epidem. & State M., 13-22.—Dunn, M. J. The housing problem as it affects public health nursing activities. Pub. Health Rep., Wash., 1940, 55: 1879-84. Also repr.—Fukushima, M. Diseases of infants and children in the slum-district of Kyoto City in Japan Orient. J. Dis. Inf., Kyoto, 1930, 8: 27.—Korach, A. What medical students think about slum conditions. Med. Rec , N. Y., 1941, 154: 15!-8.— Krichevskaia, E. R., Tsesarskaia, S. I., & Andrushkova, E. G. [The work of the dispensary physician in collective housing] Borba s tuberk. Moskva, 1934, No. 8, 16-9.—Marquette, K. Housing and health relationships re- examined. Pub. Health Rep., Wash., 1940, 55: 547-54.— Mitsuho, F. Di-ea.ses of infants and children in the slum- district of Kyoto City in Japan. Orient. J. Dis. Inf., Kyoto, 1930, 8: 36.— Parmanand Ahuja. Health in slums of a city. Sind M. J., 1934, 6: 173-81.—Relation of mortality to housing density. Brit. M. J., 1934, 1: 1000.—Stocks, P. The associa- tion between mortality and densitv of housing. Proc. R. Soc. M., Lond., 1934, 27: 1127-16.—Tufts, J. P. Housing and its relation to health. Pennsylvania Health, 1935, 13: 23-7. ---- Problems. Basse-Partox, F. *Le probleme du taudis. 87p. 24cm. Par., 1938. HOUSING Simon, X. *Etudc critique du taudis. 47p 8? Par., 1936. Ullrich, K. *Wohnungs- und Siodlungs- fragen im nationalsozialistischen Stnate [Miin- chen] 51p. 21^cm. Diisseld., 1938. Adshead, S. D. The housing problem. J. State M.. Lond 1933, 41: 727-34.—Albertini, C. La battnglia per labitazione Rass. Soc. ital. igiene, 1937, 59: 7-12. Allaway. A. E. The housing and slum clearance problem in Portsmouth. J. R. San. Inst., 1934, 55: 38 45. -Amic. M. Le mephitismc des habitations. Lyon med., 1936, 158: 388-93.—Bruce, G. It. Certain problems of the housing situation, both pieseni and future. J. R. San. Inst., 1931, 54: 62-1 30. Butler. W. Sonic housing difficulties. Ibid., 1932, 52: 3(i2 8. Chadwick, N. E. Some problems of the smaller authorities in the rehousing of overcrowded families. J. Slate M., Lond., 1937, 45: 545-50.— Chiodi, C. II problema della sistemazione edilizia. In Conv. lombard. casa popol. (Soc. ital. igiene) 1936, 82-94.—Coffey, D. J. Probleme de l'habitation des ouvriers urbains et ruraux dans l'etat libre d'lrlande. Bull. Off. internat. hyg. pub. Par., 1935, 27: 1791.—Edwards, D. Certain problems of the housing situation, both present and future. J. R. San. Inst., 1934, 54: 630-3.—Evmeniev, N. [Housing question ami October revolution] Profil. med., Kharkov, 1927, 6: No. 10, 81-8.—Fenton, J. Housing problems after the war. Med! Off., Lond., 1942, 67: 45.—Gerhardt, F. Sanierungsfragen in Kapstadt. Techn. Gemeindebl., 1934, 37: 169-72.—Gomen- soro, J. El problema de la vivienda: los origenes del problema. Bol. sal. pub., Montev., 1941, 2. inoca, 1: No. 2, 153-64.— Griffini, E. A. Esame retrospettivo del problema delle case popolari e case economiche. In Conv. lombard. casa popol. (Soc. ital. igiene) 1936, 13-7. Also Gior. Soc. ital. igiene, 1936, 58: 89-95.—Gut, A. Wohnungsnot und Technik des Wohnungsbaues. Gesundh. Ingenieur, 1927, 50: 385-9.— Guzman, P. A. Comunicado a la prensa local acerca del problema de las casas de vecindad. In Memoria (Venezuela Min. san.) Caracas, 1937, 485.—Holm, K. Groszstadtische Wohnhygiene, ein bevolkerungspolitisches Problem. Oeff. Gesundhdienst., 1937-38, 3: A, 725-35.—Housing and town planning; discussion. J. R. Inst. Pub. Health, 1938, 1: 514-8.— Macchiavello, A. El problema de la habitaci6n en Chile y la Ley 5950. Rev. chilena hig., 1937, 1: 26-32, tab.—Millard, C. K. The slum problem from the point of view of the medical officer of health. J. State M., Lond., 1930, 38: 722-30.------ The housing problem with special reference to the present position. Brit. M. J., 1933, 1: 1010-3. ------ Healthy housing for the poor; the present impasse and a way out. Med. Off., Lond., 1933, 49: 105-7.—Oates, G. E. Some health problems of London. J. State M., Lond., 1937, 45: 161-4.— Parea, F., & Aguzzi, F. Quartieri insalubri per destinazione. In Conv. lombard. casa popol. (Soc. ital. igiene) 1936, 114.— Piatt, F. W. Some aspects of the housing problem. J. R. San. Inst., 1928-29, 49: 598-600.—Porter, C. Housing; vour problem and ours. Am. J. Pub. Health, 1940, 30: 909-14.— Post-war housing. Med. Off., Lond., 1942, 67: 9.—Question (La) des habitations surpenpl^es et du logement des families nombreuses en Belgique. Mouvement hyg., Brux., 1914, 30: 161-79.—Ragazzi, C. A. Case e quartieri insalubri. In Conv. lombard. casa popol. (Soc. ital. igiene) 1936, 1-12. Also Gior. Soc. ital. igiene, 1936, 58: 33-48.—Ritchie, A. W. Slum clearance. J. R. San. Inst., 1932, 52: 374-84.—Robertson, J. The slum problem. Ibid., 1930, 51: 279-84.—Stevens, H. Nurses report substandard housing. Pub. Health Nurs., 1941, 33: 223-5.—Taylor, H. T. Can the slum be abolished? J. R. San. Inst., 1929-30, 50: 741-6. ------ Certain problems of the housing situation, both present and future. Ibid., 1934, 54: 634-7.—Topping, T. Special difficulties in housing. Ibid., 1929-30, 50: 734-40.—Unwin, J. T. Slum clenrance in small areas: -future outlook. Ibid., 1937-38, 58: 448-53.— White, G. S. The settlement problem of a changing neighbor- hood. Proc. Nat. Conf. Charities, 1910, 37: 240-6. ---- Problems—in United States. Haefner, J. H. [et al.] Housing America. 80p. 23cm. Wash. [1940] Alfred, H. The challenge of the slums. Hvgeia, Chic, 1935, 13: 122-5.—Porter, C. Housing: the U. S-. A. problem and ours. Med. Off., Lond., 1940, 64: 109-11.—San Antonio's hash houses doomed. Bull. Texas Dep. Health, 1937, 4: No. 5, 5. ---- Projects. Fetjcht, O. *Fortschritte im Siedlungsbau und ihre hygienische Bedeutung [Munchen] 36p. 8? Pfaffenhofen [1936] Housing and town planning. 296p. 8°. Phila., 1914. John, H. *Die neue Miinchener Kleinsiedlung am Hart [Munchen] 24p. 21cm. Pfaffen- hofen, 1936. Le Floch, J. *De la destruction des ilots insalubres. 68p. 25cm. Par., 1939. HOUSING 86' HOUSING Moncenix, A. *Contribution a l'etude de la lutte contre le taudis en France et a 1'etranger; la lutte contre le taudis a Grenoble de 1910 a 1937 [Lyon] 231p. 25cm.' Bourg, 1938. Aguzzi, F. La corsa al piu piccolo. In Conv. lombard. casa popol. (Soc. ital. igiene) 1936, 109-13.—Albertini, C. La distribuzione degli spazi Iiberi e delle zone fahbricate nello studio dei piani regolatori. Atti Congr. internaz. teen, san., 1931, 2. Congr., 2: 1-9. ------• Piani regolatori locali e regionali. In Conv. lombard. casa popol. (Soc. ital. igiene) 1936, 47-60.—Astel. Verwirklichung rassehygienischer Woh- nungspolitik in Thiiringen. Ber. Versamml. Internat. Fed. eugen. Org.. 1936, 12. Conf., 7-12.—Backhaus, O. Die Duisburger Typenhaussiedlung. Techn. Gemeindebl., 1926-27, 29: 125-8.—Banks, C. A municipal common lodging-house. J. R. San. Inst., 1936-37, 57: 96-100.—Berte, M. La casa popolare e le cooperative edificatrici. In Conv. lombard. casa popol. (Soc. ital. igiene) 1936, p. lxv. —;---- & Samory, A. Cooperative edificatrici, condomini. Ibid., 95-101.—Bock. Notwohnungsbau in Zwickau. Techn. Gemeindebl., 1926-27, 29: 312-4.—Bodascher, O. Planmassiger Aufbau der na- tionalen Siedlungswirtschaft (soziale Aufgaben) Zschr. Gesundhtechn., 1935, 27: 299-316.—Bourdeux, P. Expose" d'un programme de la nation en logements susceptible de resoudre la crise du chomage, de la sant6 publique et de la depopulation. Techn. san. mun., Par., 1936, 31: 147-55.— Carena, G. M. Piani regolatori, comunicazioni e transporti collettivi. In Conv. lombard. casa popol. (Soc. ital. igiene) 1936, 150-3.—Chiodi. La sistemazione edilizia delle grandi masse operaie dal punto di vista amministrptivo legale e politico. Ibid., p. lxi.—City flats v. garden cities. Med. Off., Lond., 1938, 59: 263.—Comey, A. C, & Wehrly, M. S. Planned communities. In Urban Plan. (U. S. Urbanism Com.) 1939, 2: 1-161.—Davidge, W. R. Planning as the basis of proper sanitary conditions. J. R. San. Inst., 1934, 55: 157-65.— Davies, B. P. Housing and town planning. Ibid., 1935-36, 56: 437-44.—Deplano, D. Piani regolatori locali e regionali. In Conv. lombard. casa popol. (Soc. ital. igiene) 1936, 157.— Ferragud Folques, E. El alejamiento de las cabras de la zona urbana de las poblaciones como medida profilactica. Actas Congr. nac. san., Madr. (1934) 1935. 1. Congr., 3: 297-301 — Finkbeiner. Kommunale oder private Wohnhausbautntigkeit. Techn. Gemeindebl., 1926-27, 29: 71.—Flumiani, E. L'azione dcll'istituto autonomo per le case popolari ed economiche di Varese. In Conv. lombard. casa popol. (Soc. ital. igiene) 1936, 159-61.—Foster, R. R., & Wickens, D. L. Estimating the volume of residential building construction. J. Am. Statist. Ass., 1937, 32: 97-104.—Freudenberg, K. Aus den Ergebnissen der Wohnungszahlung von 1925. Zschr. Schulge- sundhpfl., 1927, 40: 1; 52.—George. H. H. The abatement of overcrowding: the results of the first steps. J. R. San. Inst., 1936-37, 57: 613-21 [Discussion] 621-3.—Gorla, G. Abita- zioni collettive popolari. Atti Congr. internaz. teen, san., 1931, 2. Congr., 2: 27-32.—Graves, L. M., & Fletcher, A. H. Some trends in public housing. Am. J. Pub. Health, 1941, 31: 65-71.—Grierson, A. M. M. Some experiences of slum clear- ance procedure in Manchester. J. R. Inst. Pub. Health, 1937- 38 1: 724-32 —Gunn, W. C. Housing schemes and domestic amenities. Med. Off., Lond., 1937, 57: 149. ------ Town- planning, re-housing and slum clearance. S. Afr. M. J., 1938, 12: 278-84.—Gutierrez, A. [et al.] Per la casa del popolo. In Conv. lombard. casa poool. (Soc. ital. igiene) 1936, 165-8.— Haldane, J. B. S. Biology and town-planning. In his Ad- ventures Biol., N. Y., 1940, 213-7.—Heiberg, P. [Remarks on Danish housing policy] Med. rev., Bergen, 1927, 44: 527-31.— Heyer, F. Die Bekampfung der Wohnungsnot in Gross- britannien. Arch. Sozialwiss., 1926, 55: 141-55.—Housing and slum clearance in Scotland. Brit. M. J., 1934, 2: 189. Ilvento, A., Mazzitelli, M., & Tommasi-Crudeli, C. Abita: zioni collettive, case operaie, abitazioni economiche. Atti Congr. internaz. teen, san., 1931, 2. Congr., 3: 303-33, 3 tab.— Ichok, G. L'action sanitaire a l'^tranger; la politique du logement en Angleterre et aux Etats-Unis d'Amrnque. Kev. hvg., Par., 1938, 60: 279-88.—Keay, L. H. Slum clearance and rehousing. J. R. San. Inst., 1933, 54: 95-9.—Lemiere, G. La lutte contre le taudis par l'enseisnement manager. J. sc. monrt.. 1926, n. ser., 122: 237-9. Also J. R. San. Inst , 1926-27, 47 402-6 [Discussion] 416-8.— Moshinsky, P. HousingI asocial families in Holland. Eugen. Rev.. Lond 1939-40 31: I'l-/.— Mozolovszky, S. Lak6haz6pitkezesek 1939-ben. Magy. statiszt. szemle, 1940, 18: 473-5— Nowotny, M. Der Wohn- hausblock in der Hallgartenstrasse Frankfurt a. M (£entra - heizung, Warm wassei versorgung, Zentralbad und Aentral- wascherei) Gesundh. Ingenieur, 1928, 51: 145-50.-Ochoa J. The Argentine housing commission and its present work. Bull. Pan Amer. Union, 1936, 70: 760-5, 2 pl.—Operai. I. B. Piani regolatori. In Conv. lombard. casa popol. (Soc. ital. igiene), 1936, 178-83.—O'Rourke, H. T. Municipal housing. J. State M., Lond., 1929, 37: 331-9.—Orr, J. P. Abatement of overcrowding in London. Med. Off., Lond., 1938, 59: 69.— Perez de la Sala, R. Los espacios Ubres en las poblaciones. Actas Congr. nac. san., Madr. (1934) 1935, 1. Congr., 3: 87-98.—Petracek, J. [Collective housing] Voj. zdrav. listy, 1937, 13: 86-91.—Pria, A. Case popolari ed economiche ad alloggi multipli case per indigenti. In Conv. lombard. casa popol. (Soc. ital. igiene), 1936, 36-46.—Robinson, B. Some snags m housing schemes. J. R. San. Inst., 1936, 57: 30-9.— Rowel I, S. D. Tarrytown's new neighborhood house. West- chester Health, 1936, 6: No. 10, 1.—Salvini, G. Casa popolare e opera domiciUare. In Conv. lombard. casa popol. (Soc. ital. igiene) 1936, 184-95.—Schlesinger, E. R. A housing project as a focal point in health education. Med. Woman J., 1940, 47: 252-4.—Stanton, S. G. Central planning, with special reference to the replanning of Southampton. J. R. San. Inst., 1935-36, 56: 336-45.—Thompson, F. L. Plenary session in housing and town planning in South Africa. Ibid., 715-29.— Tourainne, A. Plans de ville et salubrity de l'habitation. Techn. san. mun., Par., 1933, 28: 417-25.—Unwin, R. The housing problem: how planned distribution may prevent crowding. J. R. San. Inst., 1935-36, 56: 602-14. ---■—■ Housing and planning. Ibid., 1936-37, 57: 169-76.------ Section B., Architecture, town planning and engineering; presidential address. Ibid., 1938-39, 59: 211-7.—Walker, W. A. Post-war housing development. Ibid., 1942, 62: 75-84.—Wiedemann, G. Franzosische Siedlungsbauten. Techn. Gemeindebl., 1936, 39: 33-5.—Wrigley, J. C. Housing progress and prospects. J. R. San. Inst., 1937-38, 58: 130-5. ---- Projects—in United States. Building construction in principal cities of the United States, December 1937. 30p. 8? Wash., 1938. Adams, F. J. The development of government participa- tion in low rental housing. Commonhealth, Bost., 1938, 25: 123-7.—Extension of slum clearance in District of Columbia. Month. Labor Rev., 1939, 48: 94-5.—Graves, L. M., & Fletcher, A. H. Developing a housing program in a Southern City. Am. J. Pub. Health, 1937, 37: 645-54.—Herlihy, E. M. The state program as it relates to planning. Commonhealth, Bost., 1938, 25: 117-21.—Inspection of F. H. A. housing. Health Bull., Richmond, 1941-42, 6: No. 3, 1.—Rathbone, P. R. The housing centre. Home Papers Internat. Management Congr., 1938, 7. Congr., 119-21.—Strickland, S. T. Housing activities, state and local. Commonhealth, Bost., 1938, 25: 111-5.—Vermilya, H. P. Federal housing. Ibid., 121-3.— Voell, R. F. The management of Federal projects. Home Papers Internat. Management Congr., 1938, 7. Congr., 114-8. ---- rural. Gloning, J. *Die Augsburger Kleinsiedlung Zur Hammerschmiede [Munchen] 29p. 8? Diisseld., 1936. Betenson, W. F. W. Rural housing in Wales. J. R. San. Inst., 1934-35, 55: 463-9.—Ekelund, A. [On the housing question in the rural districts] Lunds lak. sail, forh., 1932-33, 7-25.—Gillanders, G. Rural housing. J. R. San. Inst., 1939- 40, 60: 230-40.—Hollingshead, A. B. Changes in land owner- ship as an index of succession in rural communities. Am. J. Sociol., 1937-38, 43: 764-77.—Long, H. F. Some problems of rural housing. J. R. San. Inst., 1937-38, 58: 734-40— Mostra (La) di attrezzatura coloniale e il problema della casa in colonia. Riv. Soc. ital. igiene. 1940, 62: 72.—Najera Angulo, L. La higiene de la vivienda, factor primordial de saneamiento en el ambiente rural. Actas Congr. nac. san., Madr. (1934) 1935, 1 Congr., 3: 224-42.—Parker, W. Housing conditions in rural areas. Med. Off., Lond., 1938, 60: 261.—Pettersson, A., & Steenhoff, G. On the housing conditions in rural districts of Sweden. Sven. lak. sail, hand., 1929, 55: 89-204.—R&smerita, E., & Tiriung, M. [Rural dwellings in Roumania] In Probl. san. pop. rurale Romania, Bucur., 1940, 455-83.—Tommasi- Crudeli, C. Le caratteristiche igienico-sanitarie delle case rurali nelle zone di bonifica integrale. Atti Congr. internaz. teen, san., 1931, 2. Congr., 3: 267-72.—Vignerot, M. Le centre rural. Techn. san. mun., Par., 1937, 32: 77. ------ Rural housing and planning. Bull. Health Org. League of Nat., 1939, 8: 87-142. ---- Social aspect. Vellozo, D. O habitat e a integridade nacional. 36p. 23^cm. Curitiba, 1928. Biddle, W. W. Social aspects of large-scale housing. Proc. Nat. Conf. Social Work, 1933, 60. Meet., 426-33.—Chapin, F. S. The effects of slum clearance and rehousing on family and community relationships in Minneapolis. Am. J. Sociol., 1937-38, 43: 744-63.------Social effects of good housing; a sociological experiment. In Housing for Health (Am. Pub. Health Ass.) Lancaster, 1941, 140-58.—Deedes, W. Social problems of the new housing estates. J. State M., Lond., 1937, 45: 17-20.—Hagen, W. Gesundheitliche und soziale Folgen des Wohnungselendes; Wege zu seiner Beseitigung. Deut. HOUSING 8( med. Wschr., 1929, 55: 750-4.-—Housing and crime. World Health, Geneve, 1925, 6: 349-54.—Nelson, S. M. A settle- ment worker looks at housing. Commonhealth, Bost., 1938, 25: 161—4.- Noack, V. Die staatspoUtische Bedeutung der Wohnungsnot als Sexualproblem. Neue Generation, 1927, 23: 305-10.- Thirring, G. Wohnungsverhaltnisse und soziale Schichtung; Versuch einer Wohnungssoziographie. Allg. statist. Arch., 1928, 18: 189-235.—Thompson, W. S. The effect of housing upon population growth. Milbank Mem. Fund Q., 1938, 16: 359-68.—Voss, W. C. Housing, the in- dividual and the nation. Commonhealth, Bost., 1938, 25: 102-4.—Wohndichte und Kinderzahl. Hamburgs Verwalt., 1935, 12: 127-33. ---- suburban. BnucKEB, H. *Die Stadtrandsiedlung Hoffeld in Stuttgart-Degerloch. 72p. 8? Tub., 1938. Gehlhaar [H.] G. *Die Hygiene der Stadt- randsiedlung unter besonderer Berucksichtigung Nordsachsens. 3(>p. S? Zeulenroda, 1935. Gaumitz, H. Die Grundrissanordnungen im Siedlungsbau unter besonderer Beriicksichtigung der Stadtrandsiedlungen. Gesundh. Ingenieur, 1935, 58: 482-7.—Gundel, M. Die Bedeutung der vorstiidtiscben Siedlung. Deut. med. Wschr., 1933, 59: 1779-82.- May, P. Die Entwasserung der vorstad- tisehen Kleinsiedlungen. Gesundh. Ingenieur, 1932, 55: 217-9.—Schaum, A. Die Bedeutung der vorstadtischen Siedlung in sozialhygienischer und bevolkerungspolitischer Hinsicht mit Untersuchungen iiber die Lebenshaltung der Siedler. Zschr. Gesundhtechn., 1933, 25: 610-30.—Schmidt, F. Suburban settlements for unemployed in Germany. Q. Bull. Health Org. League of Nat., 1933, 2: 600-19.—Zimmermann, E. Die vorstiidtische Siedlung, ein wichtiges Gegenwartsproblem gezeigt an der Stadtrandsiedlung Kuhburg-Insel bei Lands- berg a. W. Zschr. Gesundhtechn., 1934, 26: 425-34. ---- Survey and inspection. Belgium. Office Central de Statistique. Recensements des maisons et autres batiments et des logements en 1930. 151p. 4? Brux., 1935. Charleston, W. Va. Bureau of Negro Welfare and Statistics. Negro housing survey of Wheeling, Williamson, Kimball and Keystone [Mimeo] 4? Charleston, 1935. Chicago, III. City Homes Association. Tenement conditions in Chicago. 208p. 8: Chic, 1901. Ishiguro, T. Statistische Angaben iiber die hygienischen Verhaltnisse in den Ansiedelungen der Colonisationstruppen im Hokkaido (dem nordlichen Theile von Japan) obi. 8? [n p 1894] Lang, A. *l"eber die Wohn- und Wasserver- haltnisse des Kreises Leer. 35p. 22cm. Bonn 1936. London7. County Council. Housing of the Working Classes Committee. Housing of the working classes in London. 168p. 8° Lond., 1913. New York, U. S. Report of the Tenement House Committee. 649p. 8? Alb., 1895. Philadelphia, Pa. Philadelphia Housing Association. Housing in Philadelphia (1934) Phila., 1935. ---- Housing in Philadelphia, 1939-40. 28p 25,2cm. Phila., 1941. Praha [Czechoslovakia.] Statisticky ufad hlavniho mesta Prahy; scit&nf bytu v Praze ze dne 1. Prosince 1930. Praha, 1935. Rossmaxx, H. [H. W.] *Wohnungszustande kinderreicher Familien in Giessen 1936 [Giessenl 24p. 8? Diisseld., 1937. United States National Institute of Health. National Health Survey. Adequacy of urban housing in the United States as meas- ured by degree of crowding and type of sanitary facilities. 13p. tables. 4? Wash., 1938. Vor.mann [H.] B. * Wohnungsverhaltnisse in Greifswald besonders der armeren Bevolkerune 52p. 8? Lpz., 1926. HOUSING Amic. Les taudis en 1936. Lyon mid., 1936, 158: 27-30.— Appraisal (.Anl techrinnie for urban problem areas as a basis for housing policy of local governments. Pub. Health Rod Wash., 1942, 57: 4 So 501.—Balashov [Data of the results of sanitary examinations of the peasant huts with instruments Gig. epidem., 1930, 9: 17 25. Banner, W. M. The housing of Negro families in greater New York. Abstr. Theses Univ Pittsburgh, 1940. 36: 21-5. -Bergman, R. [Dwelling investi".' tioris] Sven. lak. tidn., 1933, 30: 449-58.- Itritten. R. "||. Urban housing conditions in the United States. Labor Inform Bull., 1938, 5: No. 0, 1-3.—Buen, E. de. Hoja de estudio de la vivienda. Actas Congr. nac. san., Madr. (1934) 1935, 1. ( ongr., 3: 149-55.—Census (The) of housing in England. Lancet' Lond., 1927, 1: 1040-2.—Cousineau, A. Housing in Mont real' Canad. Pub. Health J., 1935, 26: 15-25.— Cruz, J., Leon. I.. A." [et al.] Densidad de la poblaci6n en Quito con rolaeion al niimero de habitaciones. Arch. Fac. cienc. m6d., Quito, 1933, 3: 55-60.—Dati statistici sulle abitazione malsane del comune di Mantova. In Conv. lombard. casa popol. (Soc. ital. igiene) 1936, 209-12.—Engelsmann, R. Wohnverhiiltnisse der kinderreichen Familien. Klin. Wschr., 1927, 6: 557-61.— Engle, N. H. Housing conditions in America. J. Am. Statist. Ass., 1935, 30: 288-94.—Federazione Nazionale Fascista dei Proprietari di Fabricati; la rilevazione statistica del mcrcato edilizio. In Conv. lombard. casa popol. (Soc. ital. igiene) 1936, 199-204.—Friedberger, E. Ueber die Wohnverhiiltnisse im Deutschen Reich. Deut. med. Wschr., 1930, 56: 18C6-9.— Gerhard, S. Berliner Wohnungsverhaltnisse. Ethische Kul- tur, 1893, 1: 325-7.—Higgins, T. S. Housing conditions. S. Afr. M. J., 1935, 9: 714-6.—Hopfner. Wohnungszahlung und Wohnungsnot. Techn. Gemeindebl., 1925-26, 28: 280-6.— Housing conditions in American cities in 1934. In Handb Lab. Statist. (Parker, F. E.) Wash., 1936, 240-2.—Housinu in Denmark. Month. Labor Rev., 1938, 46: 1363-6.—HousinK in Glasgow. Rep. M. Off. Health Glasgow, 1934, 139 .".2. Housing in Scotland. Lancet, Lond., 1934, 2: 624.— Housing in the United States. Q. Bull. Health Org. League of Nat., 1936, 5: 823-41.—Hughes, E. A. County home survey! Annual Rep. Illinois Dep. Pub. Welf., 1940, 23: 213-5.— Kaestner, F. Probleme und Begriffe der niichsten Reichs- wohnungszahlung. Allg. statist. Arch., 1936, 26: 12-39.— Meier, E. Die Wohnungsverhaltnisse im Deutschen Reich. Arch, sozial Hyg., 1928, n. F., 3: 243-7.—Messerli, F. M. Impressions d'un hygigniste europ6en en parcourt les villes am^ricaines. Techn. san. mun., Par., 1933, 28: 318-28.— Nation's (The) first census of housing. Occup. Ther. Rehabil., 1940, 19: 51-3.—Nystrbm, B. Observations on the possibility of improving the international comparability of building and housing statistics. Bull. Inst, internat. statist., Haye (1936) 1937, 29: pt 3, 279-94.—Ortega, J. La vivienda urbana insalubre en Espafia. Actas Congr. nac. san., Madr. (1934) 1935, 1. Congr., 3: 59-70.—Porter, C. Letter from Great Britain. Am. J. Pub. Health, 1933, 23: 723-7.—Ritter, H. Der Generalbebauungsplan von Krakau. Techn. Gemeindebl., 1941, 44: 53.—Ruhland, G. C. An experiment in housing sur- vey and inspection procedures for health departments; progress report of the subcommittee on housing survey procedures, Committee on the Hygiene of Housing. In Housing for Health (Am. Pub. Health Ass.) Lancaster, 1941, 37-47.—Savage, W. Some problems of housing inspection. In his Pract. Pub. Health Probl., Lond., 1941, 167-79.—Spiegelberg, O. Wiener Wohnungsnot und Neuerungen im Wohnhausbau. Gesundh. Ingenieur, 1926, 49: 33. Also Zschr. Gewerbehyg., 1920, 32: Beibl., 59.—Thirring, G. Reflexions sur la sociographie des maisons et logements. Bull. Inst, internat. statist., Haye, 1938, 28: 1. hvr., 115.—Wernekke. Die Stadt Fort Peck in den Vereinigten Staaten. Techn. Gemeindebl., 1938, 41: 33-5. ---- Technical methods. Lehmkuhl, H. *Die Siedlungstypen in Buer; ihre Vorziige und Nachteile. 26p. 8? Rostock, 1925. Allen, E. G. Town planning from an architectural stand- point. J. R. San. Inst., 1937-38, 58: 125-30.—Bassetti, A. Le citU giardino nei loro aspetti economico, igienico, sociale. In Conv. lombard. casa popol. (Soc. ital. igiene) 1936, 124-34.— Brogho, G. Case aUoggi singoli, case minime. Ibid., 28-35.— Finkbeiner. Beschrankung der Wohnungsgrosse. Gesundh. Ingenieur, 1927, 50: 793.—Fleury, J. L'habitation collective construite en hauteur. Techn. san. mun., Par., 1937, 32: 64—70.—Grifnni, E. A. L'orientamento solare degli alloggi operai in Italia; la difesa contro il sole. Atti Congr. internaz. teen, san., 1931, 2. Congr., 3: 415-21.—Kuny, W. Photo- grammetrie als Grundlage fiir Landesplanung und Stiidtebau. Techn. Gemeindebl., 1941, 44: 15-7.—Mella. Entwicklmms- formen einer Ruhrstadt. Ibid., 1-3.—Nussbaum, H. C. Die technischen und wirtschaftlichen Gesichtspunkte fiir die Gestaltung der Neusiedlungen und die Herstellung dei Neu- bauten von Heimen und beschiedenen Wohnungen. Erg. Hyg., 1920, 4: 329-82.—Paz Maroto, J., & Cort, C. La tecnica sanitaria ante la Sanidad nacional. Actas Congr. nac. san., Madr. (1934) 1935, 1. Congr., 3: 78-86.—Penati, C. Piani regolatori: citt& sateUiti, cittA giardino, quartieri giardino. In Conv. lombard. casa popol. (Sot;, ital. igiene) 1936, 61-5 — Schmidt-Lange, W. Zur Behebung der Feuchtigkeit in Sied- lungen. Oeff. Gesundhdienst, 1937-38, 3: A, 820-6.—Taylor, HOUSING 869 HOUSING S. P. Housing: its technical progress. J. R. San. Inst., 1937- 38, 58: 135-44.—Technische Neuheiten fiir die Gemeinden auf der Leipziger Messe. Techn. Gemeindebl., 1941, 44: 25-9.— Turley, A. W. Disinfestation of furniture, etc., in connection with the removal of tenants from houses. J. R. San. Inst., 1937-38, 58: 427-35.—Twichell, A. A. Heating, lighting, and noise conditions in recent housing projects; preliminary report on a field study of the Committee on the Hygiene of Housing. In Housing for Health (Am. Pub. Health Ass.) Lancaster, 1941, 67-89. ---- urban. Buttenheim, H. S. Urban land poUcies. In Urban Plan (U. S. Urbanism Com.) 1939, 2: 211-366.—Spath, K. Die Bedeutung der Massenverkehrsmittel fiir das Siedlungs- und Wohnungswesen in den Groszstadten. Techn. Gemeindebl 1926-27, 29: 243-6.—Wirth, L., & Shils, E. Urban living conditions. In Urban. Plan. (U. S. Urbanism Com.) 1939, 2: 163-209.—Wood, E. E. Urban housing in the United States. Home Papers Internat. Management Congr., 1938, 7. Congr., 91-4.—Yuill, C. H. Urban housing. Commonhealth, Bost., 1938, 25: 127-33. ---- Workers' projects. Drigalski, W. von, Herrmann, H. P., & Richter, F. Arbeit und Wohnung. 67p. 8° Berl., 1931. George, W. L. Labour and housing at Port Sunlight. 218p. 12? Lond., 1909. Germany. Statistisches Amt. Abteilung fur Arbeiterstatistik. Beitrage zur Arbeiter- statistik Nr. 11: Wohnungsfiirsorge in deutschen Stadten. 635p. 8? Berl., 1910. Great Britain. Royal Commission on Housing in Scotland. Report of the Royal Commission on the housing of the industrial population of Scotland, rural and urban. 460p. fol. Edinb., 1917. Roberts, H. The dwellings of the laburiong classes, their arrangement and construction. 47p. 8? Lond. [1850] Thomas, A. J. Industrial housing. 61p. 8? Bayonne [1925] Wood, E. E. The housing of the unskilled wage earner; America's next problem. 321p. 8°. N. Y., 1919. Adams, T. Industrial housing and public health in metro- politan regions. In Johns Hopkins Univ. School Hyg. De Lamar Lect., Bait. (1925-26) 1927, 70-88.—Bau von Heuer- lings- und Werkwohnungen sowie von Eigenheimen fiir land- liches Arbeiter und Handwerker. Reichsgesundhbl., 1937, 12: 419.—Cattlin, O. Provision and planning of working-class dwelUngs: post-war poUcy. J. R. San. Inst., 1931, 52:103-14.— Civit, M., & Civit, A. Proyecto para la construcci6n de casas colectivas destinadas a obreros y modestos empleados de la administraci6n y libres, a efectuarse por el gobierno de la Provincia de Mendoza. Congr. argent, urbanismo (1935) 1937, 1. Congr., 2: 273-86.—Comites de Patronage des habita- tions ouvriSres et des institutions de pr^voyance. Bull. san. pub., Brux., 1938, 3: 594-603.—Descroix, L. Le probleme de l'habitation ouvrifire et familiale en Grande-Bretagne. Techn. san. mun., Par., 1938, 33: 62-73. ------ L'habitation ouvriere et familiale. Ibid., 92-5. ------ & Wiener. Le probleme de l'habitation ouvriere et familiale en AUemagne. Ibid., 85-92.—Evmeniev, N. V. [Dwellings of Don basin miners] Profil. med., Kharkov, 1927, 74-87.—Gaggero, A. E. Viviendas higienicas para obreros. Bol. Cons. nac. hig., Montev., 1930-31, 25: 350-7.—Gurruchaga. La habitaci6n obrera y las ordenanzas municipales. Congr. espan. internac. tuberc. (1912) 1914, 2. Congr., 2: 342-4.—Hofstede, G. W. P. [Housing of the coolie women on the rubber plantation of the Delie Company] Ziekenhuis, 1927, 18: 39-43.—Hopkins, E. D. Pautas mfnimas para el saneamiento de las minas del Peru en lo relativo a viviendas. Bol. Of. san. panamer., 1941, 20: 1128-35.—Housing of industrial natives in Natal. Annual Rep. S. Africa Dep. Pub. Health, 1934-35, 52-4.—Oeuvre (L') de la Compagnie d'Alais, Froges, Camargue en faveur de ses employes. Ann. hvg., Par., 1929, n. ser., 7: 306-10.—Jervis, J. J. Housing and industry. J. State M., Lond., 1935, 43: 383-91.—Logement (Le) ouvrier en France depuis la guerre. Bull. Off. internat. hyg. pub., Par., 1922, 14: 395; 1243 — Ollivier, M. L'habitation ouvriere. C. rend. Serv. san. prov. Quebec, 1921, 9: 40-50.—Rohde. Gefolgschaftsheime fUr Wanderarbeiter in Ziegeleien. Zbl. Gewerbehyg., 1938, n. F., 15: 232-5.—Sandt, T. van de. Entwicklung und Lage des Werkwohnungsmarktes unter besonderer Berucksichtigung der Bergwerkswerkwohnungen und Bergmannsaltwohnungen im Bereich des Siedlungsverbandes Ruhrkohlenbezirk. Volks- wohlfahrt, 1930, 11: 37-46.—Sologub, J. [Habitations for ™H £k rrke,roo4n*D?"trievsk Stalin district)] Profil. med. Kharkov 1927, 6: No. 5, 96-101.—Specter, R. [Sani- tary-housing and social welfare conditions of a group of female workers in the jute factory] Ibid., No. 8-9, 58H51. ---- in wartime. Hutton, J. E. Welfare and housing; a practi- cal record of war-time management. 192p 12° Lond., 1918. United States. Department of Labor. Bureau of Industrial Housing and Trans- portation. War emergency construction (hous- ing war workers) report of the United States Housing Corporation. 2v. 391p.: 524p 4° Wash., 1919-20. [United States] National Housing Asso- ciation. A symposium on war housing held under the auspices of the National Housing Association, February 25, 1918, Philadelphia. 141p. 8? [N. Y., 1918] Carey, J. Memorandum on defense housing submitted to the Office of Production Management by the Congress of Industrial Organizations Housing Committee, January 23, 1941. In Hearings Nat. Defense Migr. U. S. Congr. H. Repr., 1941, 77. Congr., 1. sess., pt 17, 6827-31.—Defense (The) housing problem. Month. Bull. Maryland Dep. Health, 1941- 42, 13: 93-5.—Igloo (The) and environmental sanitation. Health Bull., Richmond, 1941-42, 6: No. 5, 3.—Nurnberg, M. Housing between boom and bottlenecks. Social Res., 1941, 8: 189-212.—Owens, C. P. Public and private housing in defense areas. J. M. Ass. Alabama, 1941-42, 11: 332-4.—Palmer, C. F. Families of enlisted personnel. In Hearings Nat. Defense Migr. U. S. Congr. H. Repr., 1941, 77. Congr., 1. sess., pt 11, 4318.— Pleasants, H., jr. Adequate housing a national defense problem. Pennsylvania Health, 1941-42, 2: No. 11, 10.—Wohnungs- wirtschaft (Die) im Kriege. Aerztebl. Hessen, 1940, 8: 30-3. HOUSING and town planning, vi, 296p. 8? Phila., Am. Acad. Polit. & Social Sc, 1914. The Annals, 1914, 2: January. HOUSEMAID'S knee. See under Patella. HOUSSAY, Bernardo Alberto, 1887- Hypophyse et metabolisme des hydrates de carbone. p.264—82. 24cm. Liege, Imp. G. Thone, 1937. Extrait du Volume jubilaire public en l'honneur du Prof. J. Demoor. ---- Orientaciones modernas en el estudio de la fisiologia normal y patol6gica del sistema nervioso. 8p. 2Qy2cm. Rosario, Pomponio, 1939. Also Actas Congr. nac. med., C6rdoba, 1938, 1: 395, &c. See also Buenos Aires. Universidad. Facultad de Agro- nomia y Veterinaria. El Professor Bernardo A. Houssay. 27p. 2254cm. B. Air., 1939. Also Alfaro, A. En el jubileo del Prof. Bernardo Houssay. Sem. mid., B. Air., 1934, 41: pt 2, 1949-53.—[Portrait] Libro de oro (B. Air. Fac. cienc. mid.) B. Air., 1941, p.[32] HOUSSAY, Paul, 1903- *Contribution a 1'et.ude des indications et des rdsultats des injec- tions intraveineuses de salicylate de soude chez l'enfant. 76p. 8? Par., Jouve & cie, 1933. HOUSTON, Alexander, 1865-1933. [Obituary] Brit. M. J., 1933, 1: 899. Also Lancet, Lond., 1933, 2: 1065. HOUSTON, Hazel. See Solomon, C, & Houston, H. Pharmacology, etc. 3. ed., rev & reset. 799p. 21cm. Phila. [1938] Also 4. ed. rev. 800p. 21cm. Phila. [1940] HOUSTON, Ruth Elliott. Modern trends in physical education facilities for college women. xx p. 1 1. 198p. incl. pl. plan. 26cm. N. Y., A. S. Barnes & co., 1939. HOUSTON, Trim, 1875-1941. Ezell, H. Obituary. J. Am. Dent. Ass., 1941, 28: 1901, portr. HOUSTON, William Richardson, 1873- The art of treatment, xi, 744p. 8? N. Y., Macmillan co., 1936. HOUSTON 87 HOUSTON. Texas. City Clerk. Annual report of the Departments. Houston (1904-) 1905- HOl'STON, Texas. Health Department. Annual report of vital statistics. Houston (1931-32) 1932-33. Mimeographed. ---- Report of vital statistics [monthly] Houston, 1931-33. Mimeographed. HOUSTON, Texas. Heights Sanitorium. Southwestern hospital reports. Houston, v.l, No. 3, 1915. HOUSTON, Texas. Coogle, C. P. A disease census for Houston and Harris county. Med. Rec, S. Ant., 1934, 28: 416.—Coole, W. A. A health study of Houston for the year 1938. Ibid., 1939, 33: 253- 8. HOUSTOUN, Robert Alexander, 1883- Vision and colour vision, vii, 238p. 102 illust. 8? Lond., Longmans, Green & co., 1932. HOUTHUIS, Mathijs Johan Julius. ♦Bijdrage tot de diagnostiek en bestrijding der para- tuberculose. 163p. 8? Utrecht, Kemink & zoon, 1932. HOUTSAEGER, C. Les nerfs craniens; dtude anatomo-clinique. 876p. illust. pl. 8? Lou- vain, 1932. HOUTROUVV, Thedo, 1902- *Ueber die gerichtlich-medizinische Wurdigung von Biss- verletzungen von Mensch und Tier unter Mit- teilung zweier Falle von Tod durch Hundebiss Munchen] p.89-111. 8? Berl., J. Springer, 1930. Also Deut. Zschr. gerichtl. Med., 1930-31, 16: HOUTTUYN, Martin, fl. 1800. Stellfeld, C." Houttuyn. Tribuna farm., Curitiba, 1942, 10: 8. HOUY, Maria, 1906- ♦Ueber das Unter- kiefersarkom [Munster] 25p. 8? Bottrop, VY. Postberg, 1935. HOUZE, Emile, 1848-1921. Necrologie. Bull. Soc. anthrop. Bruxelles, 1921, 36: 165.— Willems, E. Emile Houz4, un anthropologue et l'anthropologie. Ibid., 1922, 37: 18-30. HOUZE, Marcel Alexandre Victor, 1906- *Contribution a l'etude des nephrites experi- mentales chez le chien [Alfort] 45p. 8? Par., Presses Modernes, 1930. HOUZEAU, Germaine, 1901- *A propos d'un cas de thyro'idomanie. 59p. 8? Par., Vigot freres, 1936. HOUZEAU, Pierre Leon, 1902- *Les stomatites de l'huile grise. 52p. 8? Par., Vigot freres, 1929. HOUZEL, Gaston. Traitement des fractures compliquees de guerre par les appareils du Comite Franco-Americain. 89p. 8? Par., Impr. Tvpogr., 1918. HOUZEL, Guy Gaston Clement, 1906- *Le lumbago; les affections auxquelles il appar- tient; son interpretation dans les accidents de . travail. 96p. 8? Par., N. Maloine, 1930. HO Van Ke, 1906- *La pollution de 1'atmosphere des grandes villes en rapport avec leur developpement. 64p. 8? Par., M. Lac, 1932. HOVDE, Anders G., 187,5-1938. Obituary. Tr. Am. Acad. Ophth. Otolar., 1939, 416. HOVE, Menno van, 1908- ♦Unter- suchungen iiber Haufigkeit von Erbkrankheiten im Kreise Leer unter besonderer Berucksichtigung ties Gesetzes zur Verhiitung erbkranken Xach- HOVE wuchses und der Stammbaumforsehung [Mini- ster] 42p. ch. 21cm. Bottrop, W. Postberg, 1936. HOVELACQUE, Andre, 1SS0 1939. Anatomic des nerfs craniens et rachidiens et du systeme grand sympathique, chez I'homme. 2v. S73p 121 pl. 4° Par., G. Doin & cie, 1927. Osteologie. 3 fase. illust. 8? Par , G. Doin & cie, 1932-37. ---- Le rectum et sa gaine; quatre planches d'anatomie [11] p. illust. fol. Par., G. Doin & cie, 1935. ---- Les arteres mesenteriques. 106p. illust. 8? Par., G. Doin & cie, 1936. For biography see Bonniot, A. Necrologie. Lvon chir., 1939-40, 36: 680-3, portr.—Funck-Brentano, P. [Necrologie Gvnecologie, 1939, 38: 453-8, portr.—Olivier, E. Necrologie. Presse med., 1939, 47: 1258, portr. ---- & TURCHINI, Jean. Anatomie et histologie de I'appareil urinaire et de I'appareil genital de I'homme. 2 p. 1. 306p. illust. 27cm. Par., G. Doin & cie, 1938. HOVELACQUE, Pr., MONOD, Olivier, & EVRARD, Henri. Le thorax; anatomie medico- chirurgicale. 3p., 365p. illust. 8? Par., Ma- loine, 1937. HOVEN, Franz von, 1910- *Ein neues System zur Messung der Schleimhautresilienz der Kiefer. 13p. 8? Miinch., L. Mossl, 1934. HOVENIA. Nanimi, V. Ueber die diuretische Wirkung der Friichte von Hovenia dulcis, Thumb. Tohoku J. Exp. M., 1936, 28: 149-55. HO-VINH-THONG, 1910- ♦Contribu- tion a l'etude de l'hygiene des fosses nasales. 60p. 8? Par., L. Rodstein, 1938. HOWALD, Max, -1926. Kiirsteiner, W. Nekrolog. Schweiz. med. Wschr., 1926, 56: 842. HOWALD, Rudolf. *Pathogenese der grossen Milzzysten (mit zwei eigenen Beobachtungen) [Geneve] p.349-71. 8? Munch., J. Bergmann, 1926. Also Frankf. Zschr. Path., 1924, 30: HOWARD, Campbell Palmer, 1876-1936 The diagnosis and treatment of pneumonia. vii, 263p. 8? N. Y., Oxford Univ. press, 1931. Forms v.10, Oxford Monogr. Diagn. Treat. (H. A. Christian) For biography see Beye, H. L. Obituary. Canad. M. Ass. J., 1936, 35: 104 HOWARD, Charles Norman, 1875-1935. Obituary. Tr. Am. Acad. Ophth. Otolar., 1936, 41: 657. HOWARD, Christopher. Bedside manners. [4] 104p. 8? Lond., J. Bale, sons & Danielsson, 1932. ---- Physic and fancy [155]p. 8? Lond., Hutchinson & co. [19371 HOWARD, Edelbert Merten. The Howard method of bio-chemic feeding; a textbook on foods obtained from sun, vegetables, and mother earth. 62 1. 8? Bost., Kensington pub [1932] HOWARD, Eugene Henry, 1850-1927. Obituary. Psychiat. Q., Alb., 1927, 1: 517, portr. HOWARD, Ewing Fox, 1874-1933. Bryan, G. S. The universal challenge (Ewing Fox Howard oration) N. Orleans M. & S. J., 1935-36, 88: 205-70.— Matas, R. Ewing Fox Howard memorial oration. Mississippi Doctor, 1941-42, 19: 80. HOWARD, Frank Eugene, 1878- , & PATRY, Frederick Lorimer. Mental health; its principles and practice, with emphasis on the treatment of mental deviations, xvi p., 551p. diagrs. 8? N. Y., Harper & bros, 1935. HOWARD, George F. Outlines in physiology. 5. ed. 86p. 8° [Mapleton, Minn.] 1934. HOWARD 871 HOWARD UNIVERSITY HOWARD, George Thomas, -1934. [Biography] Melbourne Hosp. Clin. Rep., 1934, 5: 57, oortr. HOWARD, Glenn Willard, 1906- ♦A measurement of the achievements in motor skills of college men in the game situation of basketball [Columbia Univ.] v, 109, lp. tab. 8? N. Y., Columbia Univ., 1937. HOWARD, Harvey James, 1880- Ten weeks with Chinese bandits, xiv, 272p. 8? 24 pl. Lond., J. Lane the Bodley Head ltd, 1927. For portrait, see In Thirty Years After (Musser, J. H.) N. Orl., 1938, 35 HOWARD, Henry Welland, ed., 1877- See Transactions of the Western Branch Society of the American Urological Association. S. Franc, 1.-6., 1932-37. HOWARD, John, 1726-90. Baumgartner, L. John Howard and the public health move- ment. Bull. Inst. Hist. M., Bait., 1937, 5: 489-508.------ John Howard (1726-90) hospital and prison reformer; a bibli- ography. Ibid., 1939, 7: 486; 595. Also repr. HOWARD, Joseph Theophilus. Gynecology; or, Treatise on midwifery and physical ailments of women and children [etc.] 276p. 12? Wash., W. H. & O. H. Morrison, 1871. HOWARD, Leland Ossian, 1857- The yellow-fever mosquito. 14p. 8? Wash., Dep. Agr., 1928. Forms No. 1354, Farmers' Bull. ---- A history of applied entomology (some- what anecdotal) viii, 564p. 51 pl. 8? Wash., Smithsonian Inst., 1930. Forms v.84 Smithson. Misc. Collect. ---- The insect menace. 347p. 29 pl. 8? N. Y., Century co. [1931] ---- Fighting the insects; the story of an entomologist telling of the life and experiences of the writer, xvii, 333p. 8? N. Y., Macmillan co., 1933. For biography see Escherich, K. Leland O. Howard, 70. Geburtstag. Anz. Schadlingsk., 1928, 4: 49. ---- & BISHOPP, F. C. The house fly and how to suppress it. 17p. 8? Wash., Gov. Print. Off., 1926. Forms No. 1408, Farmers Bull. ---- Mosquito remedies and preventives. 12p. 8? Wash., Dep. Agric, 1932. Forms No. 1570, Farmers Bull. HOWARD, Russell John, 1875- Surgical nursing and the principles of surgery for nurses. 6. ed. xvi, 336p. 8 pl. 8? Lond., E. Arnold & co., 1930. ---- & PERRY, Alan. The house-surgeon's vade-mecum. 2. ed. viii, 520p. 8? Lond., E. Arnold & co., 1926. ---- The practice of surgery. 4. ed. vii, 1338p. illust. pl. 8° Lond., E. Arnold & co., 1933 HOWARD, Sidney Coe, 1891-1939. The practical application of anti-malarial measures on Malayan estates. 12p. 3 pl. 24 ^cm Kuala Lumpur, Fed. Malay States Gov. Press, 1939. Forms part of No. 2, Bull. Inst. M. Res. Malay, 1939. ----& De KRUIF, Paul Henry. Yellow jack, a history, xi, 152p. pl. 8? N. Y., Harcourt, Brace & co. [1934] HOWARD, T. Leon, 1880- [Biography] J. Omaha Clin. Soc, 1941, 2: 113, portr.— [Portrait] J. Oklahoma M. Ass., 1942, 35: 119. HOWARD, R. I. State Hospital for the Insane Report of the superintendent. Howard, 1909. HOWARD (The) medical news. Wash., v.1-5, 1924-29. HOWARD University [Washington, D. C.J Studies in the social sciences. Wash., v.2, No. 1, 1939- CONTENTS =„,!;?' n0- 1- The ??!laPse of the National Benefit Life In- surance Company. Mitchell, J. B. 1939. arrZ'^ M°' 2' A ^mParative study of religious cult behavior among Negrops. Jones, R. J. 1939 See also Brown. A. J. Howard University Dental Depart- 528^-31 " g' (K°ch' °- R' K) Chic" 1909' 1: HOWARTH, William James, 1868-1928 LonTK !?!&&J- 1928' '= 1091: 2: 3M- A,S° LanCet' HOWAT, G. R. (jt. auth.) See Jackson, C. J., Howat, G. R., & Hoar, T. P. Discolora- tion and corrosion in canned cream, p.284-90. 25Wcm [n. p., 1936] HOWAT, Reginald Douglas, 1892- Ele- ments of chromotherapy; the administration of ultra-violet, infra-red and luminous rays through colour filters. 7 p. 1. 106p. illust. 22y2cm. Lond., Actinic press [1938] HOWDEN, Richard Amaral. The mind in conflict; a simple explanation of how modern psychology sets out to solve nervous difficulties and problems, xi, 2 1. 83p. 16? Lond., Oxford Univ. press, 1931. ---- Child upbringing and the new psy- chology, viii, 105p. 16? Lond., Oxford Univ. press, 1933. HOWDEN, Robert, 1856-1940. Editor of Gray, Henry. Anatomy [&c] 23. ed. 1400p. 8? Lond., 1926. See also G., R. B. [Obituary] J. Anat., Lond., 1940-41, 75: 376-8, portr. Also Nature, Lond., 1941, 147: 169.— Obituary. Brit. M. J., 1940, 2: 885, portr. Also Lancet, Lond., 1940, 2: 826, portr.—Turner, G. Obituary. Newcastle M. J., 1940, 20: 57. HOWE, Andrew Jackson. Operative gynae- cology. 336p. 8? Cincin., R. Clarke & co., 1890. HOWE, Edwin. *Post-operative intestinal paresis. 15p. 3 pl. Milwaukee, Wise, 1936. Typewritten MS. HOWE, Elizabeth Mehaffey, 1860- Fron- tiersmen. 5 p. 1. 52p. 8? Cambr., Mass.. Priv. print., 1931. HOWE, Elliot C, 1828-99. [Biographyl In: Some Am. Med. Botanists (H. A. Kelly) N. Y., 1929, 187-9. pl., portr. HOWE, H. H. Treatise on local anaesthesia; containing a brief history of some of the agents employed, with a description of the manner of their use. 136p. 8? Weston, Vt., 1894. HOWE, Hans Ulrich, 1910- *Zangen- trauma bei hohem Forceps und spatere geistige Entwicklung. 32p. 8? Konigsb. [n. pub.] 1937. HOWE, Harold. The trend of real estate taxation in Kansas, 1910 to 1935. 22p. 8? [Topeka] 1938. Forms Circ 192, Kansas Agr. Exp. Sta. ----& MILLER, L. F. Assessment and collec- tion of farm real estate taxes in Kansas. 93p. 8? Topeka, 1939. Forms Bull. 283, Kansas Agr. Exp. Sta. HOWE, Horace Leonard, 1875-1941. Baker, L. W. A personal tribute to Horace Leonard Howe, 1875-1941. Am. J. Orthodont., 1941, 27: 229. portr.------ Biography. Harvard Alum. Bull., 1941, 43: 601, portr. HOWE, Joseph W. Emergencies; the eti- ology, pathology, and treatment of the accidents, diseases, and cases of poisoning which demand prompt action; designed for students and prac- titioners of medicine. 4. ed. 267p. 8? N. Y., D. Appleton & co., 1884. HOWE, Lucien, 1848-1928. A bibliography of hereditary eye defects. 58p. 8? Cold Springs Harbor, N. Y"., Harvard M. School., 1928. For biography see Howe, E. M. Frontiersmen. 52p. 8? Cambr., Mass., 1931. HOWE See also Derby, G. S. Obituary. Arch. Ophth., Chic, 1929, n. ser., 1: 241, portr. Also Tr. Am. Ophth. Soc, 1929, 27: 13-5, portr. Also Klin. Mbl. Augenh., 1929. 82: 104.— Obituary. Eugen. News, Lancaster, 1929, 14: 16. For portrait, photograph, as Chairman of A. M. A., 1895- 96, see collection in library. HOWE, Marcia J. Much in little; a work intended to teach how to cure yourself of disease by the power of magnetism in such a concise manner that all can understand and apply. 58p. 8? Wheaton, 111. [n. pub.] 1905. HOWE, Mark Antony De Wolfe, 1864- The Humane Society of the Commonwealth of Massachusetts; an historical review, 1785-1916. xiv, 397p. 16 pl. 20 portr. 8? Bost., Riverside press, 1918. HOWE, Samuel Gridley, 1801-76. Phalen, J. M. Dr Samuel Gridley Howe, a Yankee Cer- vantes. Mil. Surgeon, 1941, 88: 553-5. HOWE, William Augustus, 1862-1940. Obituary. J. Am. M. Ass., 1940, 115: 1470. HOWEG, Heinz, 1909- *Die Methoden der Vitalitatsprufung der Pulpa [Bonn] 27p. 21^cm. Waldbrol, C. Haupt, 1936. HOWELL, Alfred Brazier, 1886- Anato- my of the wood rat; comparative anatomy of the subgenera of the American wood rat, genus Neotoma. x, 225p. 8? Bait., Williams & Wilkins co., 1926. ---- Aquatic mammals; their adaptations to life in the water, xii, 338p. 8? Springf., 111., C. C Thomas, 1930. ---- Gross anatomy; a brief systematic presentation of the macroscopic structure of the human body, vii p. 1 1. 403p. illust. 25cm. N. Y., D. Appleton-Centurv co. [1939] HOWELL, Fleming, 1849- Our Aryan ancestors; the world's .historical people. 421p. illust. portr. map. 8? Bost., Meador pub. co., 1935. HOWELL, William Boyman, 1873- Medi- cine in Canada, xiii, 137p. illust. pl. portr. 16? N. Y.f P. B. Hoeber, 1933. Forms v.9, Clio medica (E. B. Krumbhaar) ---- F. J. Shepherd, surgeon; his life and times, ix, 251p. pl. portrs. 8? Lond., J. M. Dent & sons [1935] HOWELL, William Henry, 1860- Direc- tions for laboratory work in physiology for the use of the medical classes in the University of Michigan. 62p. 8? Ann Arb., G. Wahr, 1891. ---- A text-book of physiology for medical students and physicians. 4. ed. p. 1. 1018p. 5 pl. 8? Phila., W. B. Saunders co., 1911. Also 10. ed. p. 1. 1081p. 5 pl. 8? 1927. Also 11. ed. p. 1. 1099p. 7 pl. 8? 1930. Also 12. ed. p. 1. 1132p. 8? 1933. Also 13. ed. p. 1. 1150p. S? 1936. Also 14. ed., thoroughly rev. xix, 1117p. 24cm. 1940. See also Erlanger, J., MacCallum, W. G. [et al.] The celebration of the 60th anniversary of Dr William H. Howell's graduation from the Johns Hopkins University. Bull. Johns Hopkins Hosp., 1941, 68: 291-308, portr.—Finney, J. M. T. Address on the occasion of the presentation of the Howell plaque to the Johns Hopkins Universitv, June 9, 1931. Ibid , 1932, 50: 1-3.—[Portrait] In Book of Portraits (Ulmann, D.) Bait., 1922. ----& DONALDSON, F. Experiments upon the heart of the dog with reference to the maxi- mum volume of blood sent out by the left ven- tricle in a single beat, and the influence of varia- tions in venous pressure, arterial pressure, and pulse-rate upon the work done by the heart p.139-60. pl. tab. 4? [Lond., R. Soc. London, 18S4] HOWELL. Mich. Michigan State Sana- torium. Bienninl report. Howell, 1912-18. HOWELLS HOWELLS, William White, 1908 An- thropometry and blood types in Fiji and the Solomon Islands, p.279-339. 21l'.cm. \ \ 1933. Forms Anthrop. Papers Am. Mus. Natur. Hist., 33: HOWELL y Rivero, Luis. List of the fishes, types of poev, in the Museum of Comparative Zoology, p. 169-227. 8? Cambr., Mass., lii.'js Forms v.82 No. 3, Bull. Mus. Comp. Zool. Harvard. HOWES, Francis Williams. The chemistry of cosmetic practice. 92p. 8? [Chic, n. pub 1936] HOWES, Frank. The borderland of music and psychology; with a preface bv Sir Hugh Allen, x, 244p. 8° Lond., Kegan Paul, Trench, Trubner & co., 1926. HOWITT, Beatric Fay, 1891- The (fleet of certain drugs and dyes upon the growth of Endamceba gingivalis (Gros) in vitro, and experi- ments with Endamceba gingivalis (Gros) in mixed bacterial cultures; in filtered saliva; on a solid base; with peritoneal cells; and with diges- tive secretions. p. 173-202. 2 pl. tab. 8? Berkeley, Calif., Univ. California press, 1926. HOWITT, Frederick Oliver, 1903- See Hill, Douglas W., & Howitt, Frederick O. Insulin 219p. [Lond.] 1936. HOWITT, Henry, 1848-1934. Obituary. Canad. J. M. & S., 1934, 76: 120. HOWITZ, Frantz, 1828-1912. Kraft, C. L. [Biography] Nord. med., 1939, 1: 827-32. HOWK, Horace John, 1878-1926. Obituary. Am. Rev. Tuberc, 1926, 13: 570. portr. Also J. Am. M. Ass., 1926, 86: 1305. HOWLAND, Ivalclare Sprow. The teaching of body mechanics in elementary and secondary schools, xii, 203p. illust. 8? N. Y.. A. S. Barnes & co., 1936. HOWLAND, John, 1873-1926 See Holt, L. E., & Howland, J. Holt's Diseases of infancy and childhood. 10. & 11. ed. N. Y., 1933; 1940. Ames, J. S., & Thayer, W. S. Remarks on the unveiling of the medallion in memory of Dr John Howland. Bull. Jonns Hopkins Hosp., 1930, 46: 153-8.—D., W. C. Obituary. Am. J. Dis. Child., 1926, 32: 117, portr.—Obituary. J. Am. M. Ass., 1926, 86: 1991. Also Medicine, Bait., 1926, 5: 195, portr. Also Science, 1926, 64: 80-3. Also Mschr. Kinderh., 1926, 33: H. 3.—Welch, W. H., Flexner, S. [et al.] Memorial meeting for Dr John Howland. Bull. Johns Hopkins Hosp., 1927, 41: 311-21, portr. For Portrait, photograph, see Collection in library. Also in Book of Portraits 'Sl«i retires as curator. J. Am. M. Ass 1942 119: 90—Hrdlicka, A. Bibliography of Dr Ales Hrdlicka. Anthropologie, Praha, 1929, 7: 14. Also repr.—Keith, A. tufty years ago. Am. J. Phys. Anthrop., 1940, 26: 251-67 — Matiegka, J. [Dr Ales Hrdlicka as physician] Cas lek. Cesk., 1939, 78: 361, portr.—Seventieth birthday. Nature, Lond., l^39'TJ4?: 631.—Stewart. T. D. The life and writings of Dr Ales Hrdhdka [covering the period] 1869-1939. Am. J Phys Anthrop., 1940, 26: 3^0, portr. Also repr. For portrait, photograph, see Collection in library. Also Am. J. Phys. Anthrop., 1940, 26: Front. HRUBY, Allan Joseph, 1890-1939. [Obituary] Bull. Chicago Tuberc. Sanit., 1938-40, 18:-20: 3, portr. HRUBY, Josef, 1866- [Seventieth Anniversary] Vest. desk, lek., 1936, 48: 337, portr. HRUSKA, A. Die Zahnlockerung als bio- logisches Problem im Rahmen der menschlichen Domestikationserscheinungen. lllp. 8? Berl., H. Meusser, 1931. Forms H. 24, Abh. klin. Zahnheilk. HRUSZEK, Henri, 1901- indications et rdsultats des myomectomies pendant la gestation; observations de la clinique Baudelocque de 1921-27. 82p. 8? Par., M. Vigne", 1929. HRYNTSCHAK, Theodor, 1889- Die Erkrankungen der Prostata insbesondere die Prostatahypertrophie. vi, 114p. illust. 8? Wien, J. Springer, 1932. HSIAO, Ching-Chu, 1912- *Ueber einen Fall von Retothelsarkom der Blase [Berlin] 19p. 2 pl. 23>^cm. Charlottenb., Gebr. Hoff- mann, 1936. HSI sin. Kondo, T. Studien iiber den wirksamen Bestandteil der chinesischen Droge Hsi-sin (Rhizoma Asari sieboldi) Keijo J. M., 1930, 1:223-47. HSU, Pao-Y, 1908- *Contribution a l'etude de la gastrite hdmorragique et de son traitement chirurgical. 103p. 8? Lyon, Bose freres & cie, 1935. HSUAN Shan Chen, 1903- *The com- parative coachability of certain types of in- telligence tests [Columbia Univ.] 101 p. 8? N. Y., Teachers Coll., 1928. HU, Djin Hsin, 1906- *Die mikro- skopische Technik an den Nasennebenhohlen [Tubingen] 16p. 8? Urach (Wurttb.) F. Buhler, 1933. HUANG, Hsiming, 1900- *Ueber das Vorkommen von Poliomyelitis bei Kindern nach den Beobachtungen der drei letzten Jahre in der Berliner Kinderklinik [Berlin] 20p. 8? Charlottenb., Gebr. Hoffmann, 1927. HUANT, Ernest, 1905- *Systeme neuro- veg^tatif et radiations ultra-violettes. 113p. 8? Par., N. Maloine, 1933. HUARD, Marie Josephe, 1905- Utilisa- tion de la cuti-reaction a la tuberculine et des reactions similaires dans la lutte antituberculeuse. 99p. 8? Par., A. Legrand, 1938. HUARD, P. Etudes sur les amputations et disarticulations des membres. 2 p. 1. 686p. HUARD 8^ illust. col. pl. (1 fold.) facs. 25cm. Par., Masson & cie, 1940. & MEYER-MAY, J. Les abces du foie. viii, 390p. illust. 8? Par., Masson & cie, 1936. HUARD, Serge, 1897- *Les plaies du pddicule hepatique dans la cholecystectomie (leurs causes; une technique pour les eViter) 116p. 8? Par., Masson & cie, 1929. HUARTE Navarro, Juan de Dios. Examen de ingenios [English transl. by R. C. after the Italian transl. of Camillo Camilli] [8] 1. 333p. 8? London, Adam Islip for Th. Man, 1594. ---- [The same; English translation] 8 p. 1. 333p. 8? London, Adam Islip for Thorn. Adams, 1616. See also K, W. The Spanish doctor Juan Huarte; a char- acterologist and eugenist of the golden age. Ciba Symposia, 1942-43, 4: 1253-5. HUA Tu, ca 115-205. For photo-engraving see Collection in Library. HUBAC, Andre, 1893- *Le traitement et la prophylaxie de la peste bovine [Alfort] 55p. 8? Par., Vigot freres, 1926. HUBAUT, Georges, 1906- *A propos du traitement des m^ningococcies. 69p. 8? Par., L. Arnette, 1931. HUBBARD, Charles Lincoln, 1866- See Dalzell, J. R., & Hubbard, C. L. Air conditioning, heating.and ventilating. 571p. 21Hins par HIBNER 876 HUDDLESON la curietherapie. 98p. 8? Par., Bernigaud & Privat, 1926. HUBRICH, Paul Alfred, 1902- *Grossen- und Wachstumsverhaltnissc normaler Rinder- hoden. 48p. ch. tab. 8? Lpz., A. Edelmann, 1932. HUBSTER, Charles, 1906-34. Necrologie. Strasbourg med., 1934, 94: 478-80. HUC, G. Le rachis. p. 1245-363. 8? Par., ur.i7. In Traite chir. orthop. (Ombredanne) Par., 1937, 2: ---- & BRISARD, Pierre. La scoliose. p. 1577-694. 8? Par., 1937. In Traite chir. orthop. (Ombredanne) Par., 1937, 2: HUCHET, Pierre, 1909- *Les sinusites chroniques d'origine dentaire; 6tude critique de leur traitement chirurgical. 47p. 25}£cm. Par., Vigot freres, 1939. HUCHET, Rene Marie, 1908- *La luxation de l'extremite inferieure du cubitus; etude des differents procedes de traitement. 75p. 24cm. Par., L. Arnette, 1938. HUCHIN, Frederic Louis Augustin, 1903- *Population bovine du Pas-de-Calais [Alfort] 67p. 2 maps. 8? Calais, Impr. des Orphelins, 1928. HUCHISON, Robert. Some principles of diagnosis, prognosis, and treatment; a trilogy. 3 p. 1. 54p. 12? Brist., J. Wright & Son, 1928. HUCHZERMEYER, Hermann, 1904- *Beitrag zur Frage der Pseudotabes. 24p. 8? Miinst., J. Bredt [1932] HUCK, Peter, 1906- *Was leistet die Jodtherapie des Kropfes? 28p. . 8? Berl. [n. pub.] 1932. HUCK, Walter, 1912- *Die Spren- gel'sche Deformitat in den letzten 10 Jahren. 28p. 4 pl. 23cm. BerL, R. Pfau, 1937. HUCKE, Erich, 1901- *Beitrag zur Rontgenbestrahlung mit kleinsten Dosen der Iritis und Iridocyclitis tuberculosa. 18p. 8? Walldorf, F. Lamade, 1935. HUCKE, Herbert, 1904- *Beitrag zur Frage der Aetiologie der chronischen Magen- erkrankungen [Leipzig] 19p. 8? Zeulenroda, A. Oberreuter, 1934. HUCKLE, Arthur Henry Headley, 1870-1929. Obituary. Brit. M. J., 1929, 1: 181. HUCKLENBROICH, Kurt, 1906- lnter- suchungen iiber die phytotoxische Wirkung des Serums von Schizophrenen. 31p. 22cm. Bonn, H. Trapp, 1936. HUDDERSFIELD, Eng. Huddersfield In- firmary. Annual report. Huddersfield, 65., 1895-96. HUDDERSFIELD, Eng. School Medical Officer. Annual report to the local education authority on the medical inspection of school children. Huddersfield, 1908-35. HUDDLESON, Irvin Forest, 1893- Bru- cella infections in animals and man; methods of laboratory diagnosis, xiv, 108p. pl. portr. diagrs. 8? N. Y., Commonwealth Fund, 1934. ---- HARDY, Albert Victor [et al.] Brucel- losis in man and animals, xxi, 339p. incl. illust. tab. pl. portr. diagr. 23^cm. N. Y., Commonwealth Fund, 1939. HUDDLESON, James Howard, 1887- Accidents, neuroses and compensation, ix, 256p. 8? Bait., Williams & Wilkins co., 1932. HUDDLESON [Mrs.] Mary Pascoe. Food for the diabetic; what to eat, and how to calculate it with common household measures; with an intro- duction by Nellis Barnes Foster. 2. ed. xi, 83p. 8? N.Y., Macmillan co., 1926. Also xvii, llOp illust. 8? 1934. HUDE, Karl. See Aretaeus; edidit Carolus Hude. 183p. 8? Lpz., 1923. HUDE, Pierre Marie, 1894- *Les sup- purations de l'oreille moyenne chez les diabeliques; leurs complications, leur traitement mddical et preoperatoire par l'insuline. lOOp. 8? Par., L. Arnette, 1924. HUDELO, Andre, 1895- *Le glaucome dans l'exophtalmos pulsatile. 116p. 8? Par., Impr. Administr. Centrale, 1928. HUDELO, Lucien, 1863- Prurits et prurigos. 3 p. 1. 30 [l]p. 4 pl. S? Par., G. Doin & cie, 1931. ---- Pemphigus, p.431-76. 8? Par. [1936] In Nouv. prat. derm. (Darier, Sabouraud [et al.]) Par., 1936, 4: For portrait (pencil sketch by Dupont) see P. verb. Congr. derm. syph. fr., 1926, 3. Congr., opp. 32. HUDLESTON, Francis Josiah. Warriors in undress, xi, 2 p. 1. 229p. 12 portr. 8? Bost., Little, Brown & co., 1926. HUDSON, Alfred E. Kazak social structure. 109p. map. 25cm. N. Haven, Yale Univ. press, 1938. Forms No. 20, Yale Univ. Pub. Anthrop. HUDSON, E. Darwin. Johnson's family phy- sician, from the ablest medical authorities; giving numerous and dangerous diseases to which the human race is subject [&c] 127p. 4? N. Y., A. J. Johnson & son, 1880. HUDSON, Edward, 1772-1833. Koch, C. R. E. Edward Hudson. In his Hist. Dent. Surg., Chic, 1909, 1: 99.—Thorpe, B. L. Edward Hudson, Irish patriot, exile and pioneer American dentist. In his Biogr. Pioneer Am. Dentists, Chic, 1909, 28-35, portr. HUDSON, G. F. The Far East in world poli- tics; a study in recent history, vii, 276p. pl. portr. maps. 8? Oxf., Clarendon press, 1937. HUDSON, Robert J[ames] 1898- *The cause and diagnosis of the acute gall bladder [Marquette Univ. Sch. Med.] 14p. 4? Mil- waukee, 1924-25. Typewritten. HUDSON, William [1730-93] Stellfeld, C. Hudson. Tribuna farm., Curitiba, 1942, 10: 9. HUDSON, Wis. Oliver Wendell Holmes Hospital. Announcement. Hudson, 1887. ---- Description. Cutting from Minnesota Tribune, June 8, 1887. ---- Organization. Hudson, 1887. HUDSON County, N. J. Board of Health and Vital Statistics. Annual report. Jersey City, 4., 1877- HUDSON County health record. Jersey City, N. J., v.l, 1934- Formerly Monthly report of vital statistics. HUDSON County Hospital [Hudson City, N. J.] Report of the board of regents. Hudson City, 1870. HUDSON County Tuberculosis Hospital and Sanatorium. Clinical survey and report of the board of managers. 31p. 22cm. Secaucus, N. J. (1931-37) [1938] HUDSON River State Hospital [N. Y.] See Poughkeepsie, N. Y. Hudson River State Hospital. HUE, Frangois, 1879-1937. Huber, J. Necrologie. Gaz. hdp., 1937, 110: 458. HUE, Jean Marie, 1904- *Sur deux cas d'anemie aplastique aigue cryptogenetique; dtude clinique et pathologique des anemies aplastique. 72p. 8? Par., L. Arnette, 1930. HUE & HUE. See Vision. HUEBEL, Gunther, 1907- lntersu- chungen iiber das Verhalten des Milzbrand- bazillus im Korper der weissen Maus [Diissel- dorf] 22p. 8? Quakenbruck, R. Kleinert, 1933. HUEBEL, Kurt [Erich Hermann] 1896- *Ein Beitrag zur experimentellen Tuberkulose des Hundes [Giessen] 27p. 8? Wuppertal- Barmen, H. Leyer (1928) 1934. HUEBER, Hermann, 1909- *Ueber zwei Falle von Basalzellenkarzinom der Bauchhaut. 32p. 8? [Munch., n. pub., 1934] HUEBER, Joseph, 1906- "'Untersuchun- gen iiber das Lebensalter der in den Jahren 1919- 34 in Behandlung der Universitats-Frauenklinik Miinchen gekommenen Kollum-Karzinome. 31p. 2 tab. 8? [Munch., n. pub., 1935] HUEBER, Jos[eph] Leo. *Die Resultate der abdominalen Schnittentbindungen an der Basler geburtshilflichen Klinik 1920-29 [Basel] 36p. 8? Breitenbach, J. Jeger, 1930. HUEBLER, Albert, 1904- *Plotzlicher Tod aus natiirlicher Ursache [Breslau] 28p. 2 1. 8? Ohlau i. Schl., H. Eschenhagen, 1934. HUEBLER, Alois, 1909- *Nutritive Storungen des Dentins. 27p. 8? Bresl., K. Vater, 1936. HUEBNER [Antonius] Erhard [Georg] 1901- *Das Honorar des Arztes. 23p. 8? Freib. i. B. [n. pub.] 1930. HUEBNER, Arthur H., 1878-1934. Das Eherecht der Geisteskranken und Nervosen. 87p. 8? Bonn, A. Marcus & E. Weber, 1921. See also Storring, E. Nekrolog. Psychiat. neur. Wschr., 1934, 36: 229-31.—Westphal, A. Nekrolog. Arch. Psychiat., Berl., 1934, 102: 473-7, portr. HUEBNER, Elisabeth, 1903- *Impf- schaden. 29p. 2 pl. 8? Bresl. [n. pub.] 1929. HUEBNER, Elisabeth, 1911- *Kinder- sektionen aus zehn Jahren [Berlin] 31p. 21cm. Auerbach a. d. Bergstrasse, Schnellbacher, 1937. HUEBNER, Friedrich, 1909- *Welche Behandlung hat sich fiir maligne Tumoren des Oberkiefers (Nasennebenhohle) als die erfolg- reichste erwiesen? [Frankfurt a. M.] 31p. 8? Mainz a. Rh., Hansa-Druck [1935] HUEBNER, Georg, 1909- *Verhaltene schleimhautdurchwachsene foetale Knochenteile in einer Gebarmutterausschabung [Frankfurt] 15p. 8? Gelnhausen, F. W. Kalbfleisch, 1937. HUEBNER, Heinz [Oskar Alfred Fritz] 1912- *Die Stellung der Diagnose dentaler Fokal- infektion bei unklaren Zahnwurzelveranderungen mit Hilfe der Provokationsmethode nach Gutzeit. 27p. 8? Bresl., K. Klossok, 1938. HUEBNER, Helmut, 1908- *Die Blut- milchsaure des Menschen und ihre Beeinflussung durch Aethernarkose [Bonn] 14p. 8? Glad- bach-Rheydt, H. Lapp, 1931. HUEBNER, Hermann, 1914- *Ueber das Schicksal des Zahnes bei follikularer Zyste. 31p. 8? Bresl., P. Plischke, 1938. HUEBNER [Karl Fritz] Arthur, 1887- Notoperationen und dringliche Massnahmen des praktischen Arztes. 41p. 4 pl. on 2 1. 22cm. Stuttg., Franchk'sche Verlagshandl. [1939] Bd 5, Fiir Praxis und Krankenbett. HUEBNER, Karl [Otto] 1912- *Art und Verlauf von Psychosen nach dem Wochenbett [Tubingen] 19p. 21cm. Zeulenroda, B. Sporn, 1938. HUEBNER .HUEBNER, Katharina [Elisabeth] 1903- j t\ VOn Pfortaderthrombose beim Kinde und Diskussion der Splenektomie. 20p 8° [Berl., n. pub.] 1931. HUEBNER, Lieselotte [Bertha] 1911- *Die essentielle Thrombopenie in ihrer Bedeutung fur den Zahnarzt. 56p. 21cm. Bresl. [n. pub 1 1937. HUEBNER, Otto, 1909- *Die Bedeutung des Chlondbildes fur die Altersbestimmung und Identifizierung der handelsublichen Tintensorten [Jena] 25p. 21cm. Borna-Lpz., R. Noske, 1938. HUEBNER [Reinhard Kurt] Heinz, 1910- *Aetiologie und Therapie der persistierenden Oeffnungen zwischen Mundhohle und Kiefer- hohle [Munchen] 19p. 8? Zittau, Haupt & Schwager, 1934. HUEBNER, Rudolf, 1904- *Beitrage zur fokalen Infektion unter besonderer Beriicksichti- gung der dentalen Herde [Breslau] 56p. 8? Liebau, H. Hiltmann, 1932. HUEBNER, Solomon S., 1882- Life in- surance; a textbook, xviii, 496p. 21cm. N. Y., D. Appleton, 1923. HUEBNER, Werner, 1912- *Ueber die Pneumokokkenperitonitis (unter Zugrundelegung von drei Fallen) [Konigsberg] 30p. 20cm. Nauen, G. Vieregg, 1937. HUEBNER [Wilhelm Reinhold] Fritz, 1900- *Zur Pharmakologie des Strontiums [Munster] 51p. 8? Werne-Lippe, F. Grube, 1934. HUEBOTTER, Franz, 1881- Zwei be- riihmte chinesische Aerzte des Altertums Chouen Yu-J und Hoa-T'ouo. p. 1. 48p. 8? Tokyo, 1926. Forms Bd 21, Teil A, Mitt. Deut. Ges. Natur & Volkerk. Ostasiens. For portrait, photograph, see Collection in Library. HUEBSCH, Charlotte, 1910- *Ueber das Wachstum von Diphtheriebakterien in synthe- tischen Nahrlosungen unter aeroben, halb anaero- ben und streng anaeroben Bedingungen [Berlin] 20p. 23^cm. Orienburg, Freyhoff, 1936. HUEBSCHER, Anton, 1896- *Beitrage zur Speichelsteinkrankheit [Zurich] 31p. 8? Zug, J. Kundig, 1933. HUEBSCHER, Bruno, 1883- *Beitrag zur Therapie der Magen-Darm-Affektionen des Pferdes. 74p. 8 pl. 22}^cm. Ziir., Winterthur, 1939. HUEBSCHMANN, K. Editor of Ceska dermatologie; casopis 16kafsk# pro obor chorob koznfch a pohlavnich. Praha, v.3, 1922- HUEBSCHMANN, Paul C. C, 1878- Pathologische Anatomie der Tuberkulose. 516p. 8? Berl., J. Springer, 1928. Forms v.5, Tuberk. & ihre Grenzgeb. in Einzeldarst. ---- Pathogenese, Histogenese und patholo- gische Anatomie. p.7-65. 25cm. Lpz., J. A. Barth, 1939. In Tuberk. Mensch. (Alexander, H. [et al.]) See also Alexander, H., Huebschmann, P. [et al.] Die Tuberkulose des Menschen. 490p. 25cm. Lpz., 1939. HUECHTEBROCK, Anne Liese, 1911- *Die Operationsduldungspflicht bei Unfallver- letzten. 32p. 21cm. Bonn, H. Schonershoven, 1936. HUECK, Werner, 1882- Morphologische Pathologie; eine Darstellung morphologischer Grundlagen der allgemeinen und speziellen Pathologie. xx, 818p. illust. 8? Lpz., G. Thieme, 1937. HUEDEPHOL 87S HUELSEN HI EDEPHOL, Jakob August, 1902- *Die Bewertung der Alexander Adam'schen Operation an Hand der Bonner Falle aus den Jahren 1922-32. 38p. 8? Bonn, P. Kubens, 1933 HUEETLIN, Hans. *Ueber Blutbildveran- derungen bei Siiugetieren, unter Anwendung von Anabol und Cancisal mit einem Anhang: fiber das Blutbild bei Mause-Impfcarcinom. 75p. 8? Freib. i. P., K. Schillinger, 1929. HUEFNAGELS, Hubert, 1905- * Ver- gleichende Studien iiber adrenalin-ahnliche Phar- maka (Racedrin, Svmpatol, Ephetonin und Ephetonal) 29p. S?" Berl. [n. pub.] 1933. HUEFNAGELS, Paul, 1907- *Ueber die Wirkung des Lanadigin. 40p. ch. 8? Bonn, P. Kubens, 1934. HI EGEL, Raymond. See Delater, Gabriel Auguste, Huge], Raymond, Saidman, Jean [et al.] Les maladies des veines et leur traitement. 371 p. 8? Par., 1932. HLEGELE, Heinrich, 1908- *Ein Bei- trag zum Hallux varus kongenitus unter Mit- beurteilung eines selbstbcobachteten Falles. 14p. 22cm. Munch, [n. pub.] 1938. HUEGELSCHAEFFER, Helmut, 1910- *Ueber Deciduabildung in Cervixpolypen [Wurz- burg] 15p. 8? Aschersleben, Gebr. Volkhardt. 1935. HUEHN, Otto, 1905- *Ergebnisse der Resektion bei Gelenktuberkulose mit besonderer Berucksichtigung des Kniegelenkes (Verwertung des Materiales der Erlanger Chirurgischen Klinik aus den letzten 20 Jahren) 32p. 8? Erlangen, K. Dores [1930] HUEHN, Walter, 1905- *Der Verkauf einer arztlichen Praxis [Jena] 64p. 21cm. Erfurt, Rucbsam & Sohne, 1935. HUEHNER, Josef, 1909- *Ueber die rontgenologische Bedeutung intrakranieller Ver- kalkungen [Munster] 36p. 8? Gutersloh, Thiele, 1936. HUEHNERFELD, Jakob, 1902- *Die psvchogenen Reaktiorien bei der Schizophrenic p. 169-88. 8? [Bonn, S. Karger, 1926] Also Mschr. Psychiat. & Neur., 1929-30, 75: HUEHNERGARTH, Hans, 1908- *Die vaginale Uterusamputation mit besonderer Be- riicksichtigung der Stumpfversorgung. 34p. 22cm. Bonn, A. Brand, 1936. HUEHNLEIN, Hubert, 1911- *Patho- logisch-anatomischer Befund bei recidivierendem Hypopyon [Wurzburg] 43p. 21cm. Borna- Lpz., R. Xoske, 1936. HUELLSTRUNG, Herbert, 1908- *Ueber gesetzliche Bestimmungen und Erfolge der Zwangssterilisieruns; und Zwangskastration [Bonn] 31p. 8° Diisseld., G. H. Nolte, 1934. HUELLSTRUNG, Paul, 1901- *Einige Fragen aus der Klinik der Tabes vom Standpunkt der Versicherungsmedizin. 42p. 8? Bonn, P. Kubens, 1929. HUELS, Karl, 1908- *Ueber das Ver- halten des Herzminuten-Volumens in der Schwan- gerschaft. 30p. 8? Bonn, H. Schonershoven, 1932 HUELSEBERG, Wilhelm, 1895- *Ueber Poikilodermie. 44p. pl. 8? Gott., E. Grosse, 1927. HUELSEBUSCH, Franziska, 1911- *Ge- bisszustande der Essener Berufsschiilerinnen unter besonderer Berucksichtigung von allge- meiner Korperkonstitution und weiblicher Reife- entwicklung [Munster] 30p. 8? Bottrop, W. Postberg, 1935. HUELSEN, Christian, 1S5X-1935. Obituary Nature, Lond., 1935, 135:421. HIELSENBECK. Richard. Wald, R. Moderne Dichter-Aerzte; Schilderungen aus dem Strom der Zeit; Richard Huelsenbeck. Fortsch. Med., 1932 50:913-21. HUELSHOFF, Georg, 1907 *I)as Lipo- dermoid der Bindehaut (Wiirzburg] 19p. 8° Bottrop, W. Postberg, 1935. HUELSMANN, Erich. 1900- *Ueber die Beziehungen zwischen Erkrankungen der Zahne und der Augen. 35p. 8? Bonn, P. Kubens, 1927. HUELSMANN, Friedrich [Wilhelm] 1911- *Echinokokkus als Nebenbefund beim Granulo- sazelltumor, ein Beitrag zur Zuverlassi^'keit der Echinokokken-Hautreaktion [Munster] 19p. 21cm. Quakenbruck, R. Kleinert, 1937. HUELTL, Hiimer, 1868-1940. Adam. L [Obituary] Orv. hetil., 1940, 84: 38. Also NV'pegeszsegugy, 1940, 21: 148. HUEMME, Hans [Wilhelm] 190K- *leber den Einfluss von Zink, Aluminium, Kupfer, Mangan auf die Eiweissverdauung. 8p. 8? Miinst. [n. pub.] 1935. HUEMMER, Anton, 1907- *Diiitbe- handlung bei Entziindungen [Erlangen] 27p. 8° Forchheim, F. Gurtler, 1935. HUEMMER, Fritz, 1900- *Kunstfehler in der Zahnersatzkunde; ihre Folgen und foren- sische Bedeutung [Erlangen] 59p. 8? Xiirnb., H. Kammerer, 1929. HUENCKEN, Gretlies, 1910- ♦Elek- trische Einfliisse der verschiedensten zahnarzt- lichen Materialien im Munde auf Zahne und Schleimhaut und ihre Einwirkungen auf den menschlichen Organismus. 30p. 8? Miinch., Bayer. Druck [1934] HUENDER, Christian. *Luftembolie wahrend der Geburt und in der Nachgeburtsperiode bei Placenta praevia [Basel] 23p. 8? Disentis, J. Condrau, 1915. HUENDGEN, Peter, 1890- *Ueber die Kombination von Epilepsie und Hysterie; ein Beitrag zur Lehre der Hystero-Epilepsie [Frank- furt] 48p. 8? Mainz, Lehrlingshaus, 1917. HUENE, Friedrich von, 1875- Wirbel- tierfaunen des permischen Festlandes in Europa und ihre Zusammenhange. 47p. 2 ch. 8? Stuttg., F. Enke, 1925. Forms H. 9, Tubing, naturwiss. Abh. HUENECKE, Hans [Johannes Richard] 1906- *Das Zahnwurzelgranulom als Ursache von Allgemeinerkrankungen [Leipzig] 35p. 8? Zeulenroda, A. Oberreuter, 1931. HUENERBEIN, Margarete, 1901- *Toxi- kosen jenseits des Sauglingsalters. 26p. 2 ch. 8? Bonn, P. Kubens, 1928. HUENERMANN, Wilhelm. Priester der Ver- bannten: Damian de Veuster, ein flamischer Held. 322p. 8? Innsbruck, Tyrolia-Verl. [1938] HUENGER, Max, 1910- *Toxikologische Versuche mit Oleum anisi. 32p. 8? Lpz., A. Edelmann, 1937. HUENI, Emanuel, 1891 *Der medizi- nische Briefwechsel zwischen Paul Usteri und Albrecht Rengger; ein Beitrag zur Geschichte der Medizin am Ende des 18. Jahrhunderts. 77p. 8? Ziir., Tschopp & cie, 1930. HUENI, Karl. *Ueber die Haufigkeit der progressiven Paralyse in der Schweiz. 35p. 8? Ziir., Gebr. Leemann & Co., 1918. HUENICKE, Walter, 1910- *Der Pro- cessus coronoideus verschiedener Menschen- rassen in seiner unterschiedlichen Hohenentwick- HUENICKE 879 HUESEMANN lung vom anthropologischen Standpunkt aus betrachtet. 27p. 8? Lpz., A. Edelmann, 1935. HUENIGEN, Werner [Gerhard] 1905- *Erfahrungen mit der Komplementbindungs- Reaktion nach Neuberg-Klopstock [Leipzig] 15p. 8? Zittau, R. Monch, 1931. HUENLICH, Hellmuth 1906- Ueber die Einheilung von Fremdkorpern und ihre Entfernung. 19p. 8? Kiel [n. pub.] 1933. HUENLICH [Konrad] Werner, 1895- *Ruptur eines Milzinfarktes bei Endocarditis lenta. 15p. 8? Bresl. [n. pub.] 1928. HUENTEMANN,.Rudolf, 1902- *Ueber die Lage und Ausbreitung des Injektionsdepots bei der Stammanasthesie des Nervus trigeminus [Bonn] p.465-98. 8? Berl., H. Meusser, 1926. Also Vjschr. Zahnh., 1927, 43: HUENTEN, Joseph, 1909- *Dekompen- sationserscheinungen des kranken Herzens in Munchen in Vergleich zu anderen Gegenden des Reiches [Munchen] 24p. 21cm. Speyer, Pilger, 1936. HUEP, Karl, 1909- *Fischmehl als milch- treibendes Mittel. 31p. 2iy2cm. Lpz., A. Edelmann, 1936. HUEPPE, Ferdinand, 1852- Deutsch- lands Volkskraft und Wehrfahigkeit. 70p. 8? Berl., A. Hirschwald, 1916. Forms Bd 39, Biblioth. Coler-von Schjerning. See also [Autobiography] Med. Gegenwart (Grote) Lpz., 1923, 2: 77-138, portr. HUEPPI, Albert. *Untersuchungen uber die Veranderungen der Korpermasse der stadt- und landluzernischen Stellungspflichtigen in den Jahren 1897-1932 [Basel] 28p. 23cm. Sursee, J. Kiings, 1937. HUERKAMP, Bernhard, 1912- *Die Muskeln des linken Armes eines Somali-Negers. 51p. 25cm. Munster, H. Buschmann, 1937. HUERLIMANN, Hermann. *Ueber das Ery- thema infectiosum. 30p. 8? Ziir., Gebr. Leemann & co., 1917. HUERNY. Lotti. *Messungen der Korper- temperaturen bei Sporttreibenden. 47p. 22)^cm. Bern-Lpz., P. Haupt, 1939. HUERRE, R. R. Traitement externe des Par., 1924. Francisco. La diabetes de Sim6n Hergueta y un apendice sobre regimen de los diabeticos por Lorand. 2 p. 1. 97p. 12? Madr., Ed. Saturnino Calleja, 1921. HUERTER, Alfons, 1902- *Ein Fall von septisch verlaufender Tuberkulose ohne wesentlichen Organbefund. 27p. 8? Bonn, P. Kubens, 1932. HUERTER, Joseph, 1906- *Zur Aetio- logie und Pathogenese der Innenohrschwerhorig- keit. 49p. 8? Frankf. a. M., A. Beck, 1935. HUESCH, Ludwig, 1911- *Kohlehydrat- stoffwechsel und Glykosurie bei akuten fieber- haften Erkrankungen [Koln] 8p. 8? Miinch., J. F. Lehmann, 1936. HUESCH, Paul, 1906- *Ueber Blasen- divertikel. 38p. 8? Jena, H. Brendel, 1934. HUESCHELRATH, Juliane, 1908- *Ueber die Anwendung und die Wirkungsweise der arsenigen Saure in der Zahnheilkunde; zu- gleich ein Beitrag fiber die Frage der Bedeutung des Zusatzes von desinfizierenden Mitteln zu Arsenpasten [Bonn] 73p. 8? Koln-Kalk, M. Welzel [1931] HUESE, Johannes Frederik Otto, 1891- [Twenty-flfth anniversary of medical work] Geneesk. gids, 1941, 19: 37, portr. See Veyrieres & Huerre, dermatoses [&c] 236p. 12? HUERTAS Barrero, sacarina; con pr61ogo HUESEMANN, Heinz, 1910- *Foren- ^he Begutachtung durch den Zahnarzt. 23p 8. Tub., A. Becht, 1936. y' HUESEMANN, Toni, 1912- *Ueber Stomatitis bismutica. 24p. 8? Tiib., A. Becht, 1QSUESSEL^ATH' Giinter [Karl Bernhard] d j x rDie Pathogenese und neurologische Bedeutung der Halsrippe [Munchen] 34p. 8° Dillingen a. D., Schwab, 1930. HUESSY, Paul, 1884- Die Schwanger- schaft in ihren Beziehungen zu den andern Gebie- ten der Medizin und ihre biologischen Probleme viii, 326p. 8? Stuttg., F. Enke, 1923. ~--- Begutachtung und gerichtliche Beur- teilung von arztlichen Kunstfehlern auf geburts- hilflich-gynakologischem Gebiete. 81p. 8° Stuttg., F. Enke, 1935. Forms Beil. H. 111. Zschr. Geburtsh. Gyn. ---- Indikationsstellung und Therapie in der geburtshilflich-gynakologischen Praxis. 242p. 8? Bern, H. Huber [1935] ---- & VETTER, Hans. Der geburtshilfliche- gynaekologische Sachverstandige. 248d. 8? Bern, H. Huber [19311 HUESTEN, Werner, 1910- *Ein Beitrag zur Frage fiber das Vorhandensein tiberzahliger Zahne und deren Entstehung im menschlichen Gebisse [Wurzburg] 28p. 8? Bigge-Ruhr, Josefs [1934] HUET, Andree, 1901- *Forme endo- carditique de la maladie de Still. 46p. pl. 8? Par., M. Vigne", 1930. HUET, Ferdinand, 1909- *Traitement des abces du sein par le bacteriophage anti- staphylococcique. 58p. 8? Par., Vigot freres, 1938. HUET, J. A., & GODLEWSKI, Guy. Obesite maigreur, regimes rationnels. p. 1. p.5-43 [10]p. tab. 27cm. Par., J. Flory [1939] HUET, Jean, 1913- Contribution a l'etude de la syphilis pulmonaire. 65p. 24%cm. Par., M. Vigne, 1938. HUET, Jeanne, 1912- et son oeuvre, 1772-1838 Monmarche, 1938. HUET, Leon, 1895- (et-ude clinique, etiologique et therapeutique) lOlp. 8? Par., Impr. Progr., 1927. ---- Prurits, prurigos, strophulus, p. 183-314. 8? Par. [1936] In Nouv. prat. derm. (Darier, Sabouraud [et al.]) Par., 1936, 5: HUET, Paule, 1907- Contribution a l'etude de l'importance du traumatisme obste- trical comme facteur etiologique des encephalo- pathies de I'enfance. 64p. 8? Par., C. Serre, 1932. HUET, Pierre Charles, 1894- Contribu- tion a 1'et.ude des fractures du nez. 115p. 8? Par., Semaine Dentaire, 1927. HUETER [Franz Christian] Carl, 1862-1929. Stoeckenius, W. Nekrolog. Verh. Deut. path. Ges., 1930, 25: 374-6. HUETER, Karl, 1838-82. Hoffmann, E. Biography. Chirurg, 1932, 4: 811. HUETHWOHL, Alfred, 1911- *Unter- suchungen zur Frage des vollstandigen Arterien- verschlusses bei der Blutdruckmessung nach Riva-Rocci [Frankfurt] 47p. 21cm. Worms a. Rh., E. Norberg, 1937. HUETTE, Charles. See Bernard, Claude, & Huette, Charles. Illustrated manual of operative surgery. 513p. 8? N. Y., 1852. *Broussais; sa vie 92p. 8? Par., H. *Le prurit perineal HUETTEL HUETTEL, Hans, 1908- *Das Vorkom- men und Verhalten des Sclmielzoberhautchens in der Zahnfissur. 14p. 2 pl. 8? Erlangen, Reinhold & Limmert, 1935. HIETTEMANN, Paul, 1901 ♦Psv- ehische Storungen, bei Hysterie [Kiel] 23p. 8? Bielefeld, Rennebohm & Hausknecht [1926] HIETTEMANN, Paul, 1907- *Beitrag zur Klinik des Steinleidens der Harnwege. 31p. 8? Pegau-Lpz., H. Gunther, 1935. HUETTENBRENNER, Andreas Ritter, 1842- 1905. Ruhrah, J. Huttenbrenner, Andreas Ritter von; a note on the history of pyelitis. Am. J. Dis. Child., 1934, 48: 1367. HUETTENHAIN, Elisabeth, 1910- *Ma- laria-Therapie bei Sehnervenatrophie durch Tabes dorsalis. 31p. 21cm. Miinch., C. Wolf & Sohn, 1938. HUETTER, Karlheinz, 1904- *Gibt es eine peptisehe Gastroduodenitis? 29p. 8? Berl., Gebr. Hoffmann, 1935. HUETTER, Karl Walter, 1901- *Beitrag zur Bewertung neuzeitlicher Abdruckmethoden unter besonderer Berucksichtigung des Sauge- abdruckes und des Bewegungsabdruckes. 41p. pl. 8? Bonn, L. Neuendorff, 1932. HUETTERMANN, Kathe, 1911- *Ueber die Hirnveranderungen bei Keuchhusten mit eigenen Fallen. 15p. 21cm. Heidelb., H. Fahrer, 1936. HUETTIG, Heinz, 1908- *Ueber lange Geburtsintervalle und ihre Ursachen. 19p. 8? Berl., R. Pfau, 1937. HUETTIG, Martin, 1899- *Ueber Ver- knocherung in Sehnen (Auszug) lip. 8? Lpz., O. Regel, 1925. HUETTNER, Alfred Francis, 1884- Fundamentals of comparative embryology of the vertebrates, xiv p. 1 1. 416p. illust. diagr. 24cm. N. Y., Macmillan co., 1941. See also Kirkpatrick, Thomas Bruce, & Huettner, Alfred F. Fundaments of health [Bost., 1931] Also another ed. 576p. 8? [Bost.] [1934] Also Rev. ed. 595p. 2VAcm. Bost., 1941. For portrait, photograph, see Collection in Library. HUETTNER, Joachim-Hans, 1906- *Die Behandlung der traumatisehen Ellenbogenge- lenkskontraktur durch die Armabduktionsschiene mit Quengelvorrichtung [Berlin] 24p. 8? Charlottenb., Gebr. Hoffmann, 1932. HUETTNER, Werner, 1905- *Tonsil- lektomien bei Gelenk-, Herz- und Nieren- erkrankungen. 26p. 8? Berl. [n. pub.] 1931. HUFELAND, Christoph Wilhelm, 1762-1836. Liebarzt und Volkserzieher; Selbstbiographie; neuherausgegeben von Walter von Brunn. 159p. portr. 8? Stuttg., R. Lutz [1937] See also Herfort, K. H. [W.] "Hufeland als Lehrer und klinischer Direktor [Berlin] 31p. 8? Lengerich, 1938. Also Kiwi, M. L. "Christoph Wilhelm Hufeland und die Hygiene. 22p. 8? Berl., 1937. Also Abt, I. A. Christopher Wilhelm Hufeland (1762-1836) Ann. M. Hist., 1931, n. ser., 3: 27-38.—Buttersack. Zu Hufelands 100. Todestag. (25. August 1936) Hippokrates, Stuttg., 1936, 7: 719.—Diepgen. P. Christ. Wilhelm Hufeland und die Medizin seiner Zeit. Miinch. med. Wschr., 1936, 83: 1430-5—Hoffmann, E. Zum 100. Todestag Christoph Wilhelm Hufelands, eines Vorlaufers der modernen Dermatologie (25 August 1936) Derm. Zschr., 1936, 74: 6.5-9.—Paasch, R. Christoph Wilhelm Hufeland. Zschr. arztl. Fortbild., 1936, 33: 504.—Ruhrah, J. [Biography] Am. J. Dis. Child., 1931. 41: 1444-8. For portrait, see Collection in Library. HUFF, Carl, 1910- *Ueber die manuelle Plazentalbsung und fiber die Austastung des Uterus in der Xachgeburtsperiode [Mfinster] 19p. 22cm. Diisseld., G. H. Nolte, 1936. HUFF, Clay G., 1900- See Hegner. Robert William, Root, Francis M. [et all Parasitology. 812p. 8! N. Y. [1938] HUFF HUFF, Helmut, 1912- *Einfluss des Adrenalins auf Blutfett- und Blutzuckerkurve beim insulinhvpoglykamischen Kaninchen. 17p. 8? Heidelb.,'Kassel, 1936. HUFF, Warren C, & HOFF, Paul R. Diver- sion terraces and contour strip-cropping. 35p. illust. 23cm. Ithaca, X. Y., Cornell Univ., 1941. Cornell Extension Bull. 464, June 1941. HUFFMAN, Edna K. Manual for medical records librarians, xxi p. 1 1. 308p. incl. illust. form. 23V>cm. Chic, Physicians' record co., 1941. HUFFMAN, Hugh Martin, 1S9S See Parks, George Sutton & Huffman, Hugh Martin. The free energies of some organic compounds. 2.51 p. 8? N. Y., 1932. HUFNAGEL, Erich, 1905- *Bericht fiber die an der Wiirzburger chirurgischen Klinik in den Jahren 1921-29 behandelten Haemorrhoiden. 56p. 8? Wiirzb., G. Grasser, 1931. HUFNAGEL, Sigismond. *Etude g6nerale des eaux min£rales de la Pologne. 77p. map. 8? Strasb. [n. pub.] 1933. HUFNAGL, Hanns, 1910- ♦Beobach- tungen und Erfahrungen bei Kohlenoxydgas- Vergiftungen [Heidelberg] 15p. 22cm. Mann- heim-Seckenheim, Neckarbote, 1935. HUG, Albert, 1880- *Ueber chronische Atembeschwerden des Pferdes. 34p. 5pl. 21cm. Ziir., O. Fussli, 1937. Also Schweiz. Arch. Tierh., 1937, 79: HUG, Enrique. Apuntes de farmacologfa. 1. parte. 2 p. 1. 218 numb. 1. 32cm. Rosario, A. A. Boratti [1937] -—■— Manual de tratamientos de urgencia de las intoxicaciones agudas. 2. ed. 116p. 16^cm. B. Air., El Ateneo, 1938. HUG, Heinrich. *Zur Kenntnis der Kohlen- oxydvergiftung [Basel] p.72-88. 8? Berl., J. Springer, 1930. Also Deut. Zschr. gerichtl. Med., 1930-31, 16: HUG, Josef, 1905- *Luftrohre und Lunge des Wildschweines; XI. Beitrag zur Anatomie von Sus scrofa L. und zum Domestikations- problem [Zurich] 30p. 8? Wil (St. Gallen) F. Gegenbauer, 1934. HUG, Otto. *Die Beziehungen zwischen Zell- polymorphismus und Entzfindung untersucht an einem Fall von figuriertem Rundzellensarkom der Haut. 45p. pl. 8? Ziir., Polygr. Inst.. 1904. HUGAUD, Georges, 1908- *Le mouton du Macina; son amelioration en vue de la produc- tion lainiere [Alfort] 39p. 8? Par., L. Rod- stein, 1934. HUGEL & DELATER, G. Le systeme veineux, normal et pathologique; guide des malades et des predisposes; varices, phl6bites, hemorroides [&c] vii, 182p. 2 pl. 12? Par., G. Doin & cie, 1926. HUGEL, Hans. *Die Milzreizbehandlung und ihre Anwendung in der Frauenheilkunde; ein kasuistischer Beitrag zur Behandlung der gutar- tigen Erkrankungen der Frau. 14p. 23cm. [Miinch., n. pub.] 1937. HUGELSHOFER, Albert. *Ueber Spondylitia mit besonderer Beriicksichtigung des spateren Verlaufs derselben [Basel] 58p. 8? Berl., S. Karger, 1904. Also Jahrb. Kinderh., 1904, 58: HUGENTOBLER, Heinz, 1910- *Zur prophylaktischen Bekampfung der postopera- tiven Lungenkomplikationen mit Autovakzine. 28p. 22>£cm. Zur., Fluntern, 1939. HUGGEL 881 HUGHES HUGGEL, Johann Jacob, -1564. Von heilsamen Badern des Teutschenlands [!] 3 p. 1. 80p. [1] 1. illust. 8? [Mfilhausen, Hans Schirenbrand & Peter Schmid, 1559] ---- Von dem Aussatz. [16] 1. 8? Frankfurt a. M., P. Schmid, 1566. HUGGINS, Raleigh R., 1870-1938. Chalfant, S. A. Obituary. Tr. Am. Gyn. Soc. (1938) 1939, 63: 287-9, portr.—Obituary. Pennsylvania M. J., 1937-38, 41: 617. HUGHES, A. F. W. On the development of the blood vessels in the head of the chick, p.75- 130. 16 pl. 29cm. Lond., Harrison & sons, 1934. In Philos. Tr. R. Soc. London, 1934-35, ser. B, 224: HUGHES, D. E. R. See Cathcart, E. P., Hughes, D. E. R., & Chalmers, J. G. The physique of man in industry. 52p. 8? Lond., 1935. HUGHES, Daniel E., 1851-1902. Compend of the practice of medicine. Physicians' ed. based on 4. ed. 462p. 8? Phila., P. Blakiston, son & co., 1889. Also 14. ed. by R. J. E. Scott. xxii, 839p. 63 pl. 12? 1928. Also 15. ed. revised and edited by Burgess Gordon, xxi, 808p. illust. diagrs. 8? [1935] HUGHES, Edmund. Seasonal variation in man. viii, 126p. 12? Lond., H. K. Lewis & co., 1931. HUGHES, Harry Samuel, 1880-1938. Mason, R. E. Obituary. Week. Bull. S. Louis M. Soc, 1938-39, 33: 527. HUGHES, Henry Marshall, 1805-58. A clinical introduction to the practice of ausculta- tion, and other modes of physical diagnosis, in diseases of the lungs and heart. 2. ed. xv, 304p. illust. 8? Phila., Blanchard & Lea, 1854. HUGHES, James E. Review of 1931 narcotic legislation; with table of citations. 2 p. 1. 20 numb. 1. 27cm. [Wash., U. S. Pub. Health Serv., 1931] Mimeographed. ---- Eugenic sterilization in the United States; a comparative summary of statutes and review of court decisions, vi, 45p. 8? Wash., Gov. Print. Off., 1940. Forms Suppl. No. 162, Pub. Health Rep. See also [Bibliography] Psychiatry, Bait., 1941, 4: 660. HUGHES, Josiah Simpson, 1884- See Peterson, W. J. [et al.] The carotenoid pigments; occurrence, properties, methods of determination, and metab- oUsm by the hen. 74p. 8? Topeka, 1939. --- AUBEL, C. E. & LIENHARDT, H. F. The importance of vitamin A and vitamin C in the ration of swine. 48p. 8? Topeka, 1928. Forms No. 23 of Techn. BuU. Kans. Agr. CoU. Exp. Sta. HUGHES, Kenneth F., 1909-38. . Meinberg. W. H. Obituary. Week. BuU. S. Louis M. Soc, 1938-39, 33: 537. HUGHES, Lawson, 1873-1937. Obituary. Texas J. M.. 1936-37, 32: 787, portr. HUGHES, Leslie Ernest Charles. See Chambers's technical dictionary. 957p. 21cm. N. Y., 1940. HUGHES, Osee [Gladys] Introductory foods. vii, 522p. incl. illust. tab. diagr. 22cm. N. Y., Macmillan co., 1940. . HUGHES, Percy, 1872- Introduction to psychology from the standpoint of life-career. 2. experimental ed. 214p. 8? Bethlehem, Pa., Lehigh Univ. Supply Bur. [19281 HUGHES, Richard, 1836-1902. Ward, J. W. Biography. Pacific Coast J. Homoeop., 1939, 50:241-3. ---- & DONNER, Fritz. Einfiihrung in die homoopathische Arzneimittellehre. 228p. 8. Radebeul, Madaus & Co. [1932] HUGHES, Robert Morton, 1855-1940 [WilHamsburg Va.] The College of William & Mary. Alpha Chapter of Phi Beta Kappa. In memoriam, Robert Morton Hughes, 1855-1940; a tribute. 19p. 23cm. [Williamsb™ HUGHES, Rupert, 1872- The art of W' -n5u-LT 94P\ iilust' 8? tVan Nuys> Calif. Delta Phi Lambda Sorority, 1933] HUGHES, Thomas Hywel, 1875- Psy- chology and religious origins. 242p. 8? Lond Duckworth [1936] HUGHES, Wilfrid Kent, 1865-1942. Obituary. Med. J. Australia, 1942, 1: 122-4, portr. HUGHES, William Leonard, 1895- The administration of health and physical education for men in colleges and universities, vii, 181n. 8? N. Y., Columbia Univ., 1932. Foms No. 541, Contrib. Educ, Teachers CoU. Columbia] University. ---- Administration of health and physical education in colleges, xiii, 368p. illust. 8? N. Y., A. S. Barnes & co., 1935. See also Williams, Jesse Feiring, & Hughes, WilUam L. Athletics in education. 2. ed. 472p. 8? Phila., 1937. HUGHLINGS, John Jackson, 1835-1935. [Biography] Brit.M. J., 1935, 1: 769; 772, portr. Also Med. Press & Circ, Dubl., 1935, 190: 365, portr. HUGI, Fritz. *Qualitative Veranderungen im roten Blutbild durch Milzung [Basel] p.218-27. 23>^cm. Wiirzb., H. Stiirtz, 1936. Also Deut. Zschr. Chir., 1935-36, 246: HUGIER, Alphonse, 1873-1927. Lanos, J. [Necrologie] Paris chir., 1927, 19: 252-5. HUGO, of Lucca. Cunha, F. Hugo of Lucca and the school at Bologna. Am. J. Surg., 1940, 47: 172-80. HUGO, of Siena. See Bencio, Ugone [di Siena] HUGO, Andree, 1898- *Essai de bac- terioth6rapie des tuberculoses chirurgicales par la paratuberculine du bacille de Johne. 96p. 8? Par., Jouve & cie, 1927. HUGO, Eugene. Abely, X. La psychose d'Eugeiie Hugo. Ann. mid. psychol., Par., 1926, 84: pt 2, 97-118. HUGO, Victor Marie, 1802-85. Genty, M. Victor Hugo et la medecine. Progr. mid., Par., 1935, Suppl., 41-8, portrs.—Logre. Victor Hugo y los alienados. Rev. crim., B. Air., 1932, 19: 664-9.—McGarr, T. E. Mental characteristics of the family of Victor Hugo. State Hosp. Q., Albany, 1926-27, 12: 18-21.—Victor Hugo artiste. Progr. mid., Par., 1926, 41: (Suppl. illust.) 54.—Victor Hugo perito medico legale. Arch, antrop. crim., Tor., 1937, 57: 212-4.— Vista (La) di Victor Hugo. Minerva med., Tor., 1940, 31: pt 1, varia, 44-6 (microfilm)—Visita (Una) di Victor Hugo. Minerva med., Tor., 1940, 31: pt 1, varia, 294-6 (microfilm) HUGO, Wilhelm, 1910- *Zur operativen Behandlung des Cardiospasmus. 25p. 8? Konigsb., J. Raabe, 1936. HUGOT, Gabriel Emile, 1893- *Avorte- ment epizootique dans l'espece bovine et sa prevention [Alfort] 74p. 8? Hesdin, Herbay, 1927. „ . . fc.HUGOUNENQ, Louis, 1860- Pnncipes de pharmacodynamie; constitutions chimiques, proprietes physiologiques. viii, 390p. 8? Par., Masson & cie, 1928. HUGUENIN, Andre, 1908- *Le palu- disme d'inoculation; elude clinique et experi- mentale. 264p. 6 pl. ch. 24y2cm. Alger, Minerva, 1934. HUGUENIN, Belisar, 1876-1940. Duerst U. Professor Dr med. Belisar Huguemn, Bern. Schweiz. Arch. Tierh., 1940, 82: 223-30, portr. HUGUENIN, Gustav, 1890- Miiller-Schiirch, H. Erinnerungen an Prof Dr Gustav Huguenin. In Festschr. H. Zangger, Zur., 1935, 2: 742-8. 227475—VOL. 7, 4th series----56 HUGUENIN HUGUENIN, Jean, 1901- Contribution a l'etude de Taction anti-rachitique des substances irradi6es; Tergosterol irradie. 91p. 8 ch. 4 pl. 8? Par., M. Lac, 1928. HI CLENIN, P. Portrait. Mid. dent. Canton Vaud (O. Lazar) Geneve, 193S, 41. HUGUENIN, Pierre, 1907- Traitement de l'erysipcle par le chlorhydrate de sulfamido- chrysoidine. 104p. 8? Par., A. Legrand, 1935. HUGUENIN, Rene, 1894- *Le cancer primitif du poumon; etude anatomo-clinique. 330p. 39 pl. 8? Par., Masson & cie, 1928. ---- The same. Preface du Pr. G. Roussy. 2 p. 1. iv, 330p. 21 pl. 8? Par., Masson & cie, 1928. See also Armand-Delille, P. F., Lestocquoy, Ch., &Huguenin, R. La tuberculose pulmonaire. 2v. 499p. fol. Par. [1933] ---- ALBOT, G. [et al.] Travaux pratiques d'anatomie pathologique. 5. 6d. vi, 349p. illust. 20cm. Par., Masson & cie, 1938. HUGUENY, Marcel, 1913- *Kystes de l'dpididyme et lesions epididymaires concomi- tantes. 47p. 24^cm. Par., A. Legrand, 1938. HUGUES, Jean, 1911- *Radiotherapie de la region thyroidienne et sclerodermic. 75p. 8? Par., Risch & Gillmann, 1938. HUGUET, Luis E. *Parto rapido artificial por el metodo de Bossi. 81p. 3 1. incl. pl. 26cm. B. Air., Las Ciencias, 1907. ---- Debilidad mental relativa. 114p. 28cm. B. Air., N. Rondinone [1941?] HUGUET, Marcelle, 1895- *Des epan- chements contralateral au cours du pneumo- thorax artificiel et apres la thoracoplastie. 59p. 8? Par., A. Legrand, 1926. HUGUET, Maurice, 1906- *Etude sur le traitement electro-radioth6rapique de la maladie de Basedow. 138p. 8? Par., Jouve & cie, 1932. HUGUET, Simone Georgette, 1911- *Les septicemics a pneumocoques chez les enfants. 171p. 8? Par., L. Arnette, 1937. HUGUIER, Alphonse, 1873-1928. Dartigues, L. [Necrology] In Fase. script. (Dartigues, L.) Par., 1932, 3: 776.—Lanos, J. [Necrologie] BuU. Soc. chir. Paris, 1929, 21: 49-56. HUGUIER, Jacques. Membre superieur, membre inferieur. xii, 205p. illust. 15J/2cm. Par., Libr. Maloine, 1939. Forms v.4, Pi§cis d'anat. (Dupuy de Frenelle, J. P.) HUGUIER, Jacques, 1909- *L'anthrax du rein. 161p. 4 pl. 24cm. Par., G. Doin & cie, 1939 HUHN, Dagmar, 1899- *Ueber die Wirkung von Solganal bei subakuten und chronischen Gelenkerkrankungen [Berlin] 36p. 8? Charlottenb., Gebr. Hoffmann, 1932. HUHN [Friedrich Otto] Hellmut, 1908- *Die Entwicklung der intravenosen Dauertropf- infusion [Heidelberg] 15p. 21cm. Ochsenfurt a. M., Fritz & Rappert, 1934. HUHN, Werner Hermann, 1912- *Kri- tische Wfirdigung der Untersuchungsergebnisse iiber die Einwirkung von Fruchtsauren auf die Hartsubstanzen des Zahngewebes und neue Untersuchungen mit Zitronensaure auf Zahn- fullungen. 24p. 8? Wurzburg, Gebr. Mem- minger, 1935. HUHNER, Max, 1873- A practical treatise on disorders of the sexual function in the male and female. 3. ed. xv, 342p. 8? Phila., F. A. Davis co., 1929. ---- The diagnosis and treatment of sexual disorders in the male and female, including steril- ity and impotence, xiii, 490p. 8? Phila., F. A. HUHNER Davis, 1937. Also 2. ed. p. 1. xiii, 506p. illust. diagr. 24cin. 1939. Also 2. ed. [Rev. & repr.j p. 1. xiii, 506p. 24cm. 1942. HUHS, Enno, 1906- *Die Intrakutan- reaktion mit Ferrizyankali bei Icterus neona- torum [Halle] 12p. 8? Berl., S. Karger, 1932. Also Mschr. Geburtsh. Gyn., 1932, 91: HUHTIKANGAS, Hugo. *Untersuchungen fiber die Reaktion des Mageninhalts bei Neuge- borenen vor der ersten Nahrungsaufnahme. SSp. 8? Helsin. [n. pub.] 1936. Also Acta Soc. med. Duodecim, 1936, ser. B, 24: HUICHARD, Roland, 1913- *Etude pharmacologique et th6rapeutique des derivds iodo-ph6noles de I'h6xam6thylene tetramine. 47p. 25 Kern. Lyon, Bose freres, 1938. HUIGNARD, Christian Hortensius, 1912- *Extension ganglionnaire dans le cancer du col de I'uterus. 62p. 8? Par., M. Vigne, 1936. HUILLET, Raymond, 1908- * Pertur- bations du metabolisme des corps creatiniques dans les myopathies; essais de traitement par le glycocolle. 63p. 8? Par., M. Vigne", 1934. HUISMAN [Agricola] Roelof, -1485. Non- nulla opuscula. Ed. by Pieter Aegidius. 6C numb. 1. 15}£cm. [text] Basel, A. Cratander & S. Cruftan, Oct. 1518. ---- Epistolae variae ... de re scholastica, de formando studio ... f.llv-27v. 15^cm. Basel, 1518. In his Nonnulla opusc, Basel, 1518. HUIZINGA, Eelco. Die Untersuchung der Labyrinth-, Korperstell- und Haltungsreflexe bei den Siiugetieren. p.837-910. 8? BerL, Urban & Schwarzenberg, 1938. In Handb. biol. Arbeitsmeth. (Abderhalden, E.) Berl., 1938, 5, T. 5. B. HUIZINGA, John Gerrit, 1868-1940. [Obituary] Tr. Am. Acad. Ophth. Otolar., 1941, 46: Suppl., 26. HUKUOKA acta medica (Hukuoka ikadaigaku zassi) Hukuoka, v.31, No. 1, 1938; v.33, 1940- Continuation of Fukuoka acta medica. HULBERT, Henry Louis Powell, 1871-1928. Obituary. Lancet, Lond., 1928, 1: 941. HULBERT, James Root, 1884- See also Craigie, William A., & Hulbert, James R., eds. A dictionary of American English on historical principles. Chic, pt 1, 1936- HULDSCHINSKY, Kurt. Dementia rachitics; Studien fiber die sogenannte zerebrale Kom- ponente der Rachitis. 60p. 8? Berl., S. Karger, 1926. Forms H. 14, Abh. Kinderh. HULETT, G. D. Textbook of the principles of osteopathy. 1.-4. ed. 8? Kirksville, Mo., Journal Print. Co., 1903-6. HULIN, Marcel, 1916- *La vaccination antidiphterique dans la Quatorzieme Region. 96p. 24cm. Lyon, Impr. Sal. Pub., 1939. HULKE, John Whitaker, 1830-95. [Biography] Cat. Portr. R. Coll. Surgeons, Lond., 1930, 33; HULL, Clark Leonard, 1884- Hypnosis and suggestibility; an experimental approach. xii p. 2 1. 416p. illust. pl. portr. diagrs. 8? N. Y., D. Appleton-Century co. [1933] ---- Learning. II: The factor of the con- ditioned reflex, p.382-455. 4? Worcester, 1934. In Handb. Gen. Exp. Psychol. (Murchison, C.) Worcester, 1934. For portrait see J. Consult. Psychol., 1942, 6: opp. 117' HULL, Edgar, 1904- See Ashman, Richard, & Hull, Edgar. Essentials of electro- cardiography. 212p. 8° N. Y., 1927. Also 2. ed. 373p. 22cm. N. Y., 1941. HULL 883 HUMANISM ---- WRIGHT, Christine, & EYL, Ann B. Medical nursing, xiv, 588p. illust. 11 col. pl. diagr. 22}£cm. Phila., F. A. Davis co., 1940. Also 2. ed. xiv, 650p. 22^cm. 1942. HULL, James Porterfield, 1872-1938. Powell. D. Obituary. CaUfornia West. M., 1938, 49: 329. HULL, John, 1761-1843. [Biography] In Centen. Hist. Manchester M. Soc. (E. M. Brockbank) 1934, 53-74, portr. HULL, Thomas Gordon, 1889- Diseases transmitted from animals to man; with an intro- duction by Veranus A. Moore, x, 7 1. 350p. 8? Springfield, 111., C. C Thomas, 1930. Also 2. ed. xiii, 403p. incl. illust. (incl. map.) tab. diagr. 24/2cm. 1941. See also Bauer, William W., & Hull, Thomas G. Health education of the pubUc. 227p. 8? Phila., 1937. HULL, Engl. General Infirmary. Annual reports. Hull, 97.-101., 1879-83. Hull Royal Infirmany carries on. Nurs. Times, Lond., 1941, 37: 1036. HULL and Sculcoates Dispensary. Annual reports. Hull, 66.-69., 1880-83. HULL City and County Asylum [formerly Hull Borough Asylum (mental)] Annual report. Hull, 1876; 1878-89; 1890-1904; 1907/8; 1910-16. HULLlGER, Pierre. A new treatment of tuberculosis, x [1] 146p. 8? Lond., H. K. Lewis & co., Ltd., 1930. HULLIHEN, Simon P. 1810-57. [Biographical sketch and portrait. CUpping from WheeUng, W. Va., Sunday News, Mar. 18, 1934] Thorpe; B. L. Simon P. Hullihen, pioneer and expert in oral surgery and founder of the Wheeling Hospital. In his Biogr. Pioneer Am. Dentists, Chic, 1909, 129-40, portr. See also Siler, J. F. Simon P. Hullihen, 1810-57; biographi- cal sketch to be included in the Dictionary of American Biog- raphy [MS.] 3 1. 8! Wash., 1929. HULT, Olof Torrgny, 1868- Diepgen, P. Olof Hult zu seinem 70. Geburtstag am 2. XII. 1938. Miinch. med. Wschr., 1938, 85: 1888. HULTEN, Johan Olof [Olle] 1897- *Ueber die indirekten Briiche des Tibiakopfes nebst Beitragen zur Rontgenologie des Kniegelenks. 167p. 34 pl. 4 ch. 8? Uppsala, Almqvist & Wiksell, 1929. Forms Suppl. 15, Acta chir. scand. HULTKRANTZ, Johan Wilhelm, 1862-1938. Ueber die Zunahme der Korpergrosse in Schweden in den Jahren 1840-1926. 54p. ch. 4? Uppsala, Almqvist & Wiksell, 1927. ---- Gehirnpraparation mittels Zerfaserung; Anleitung zum makroskopischen Studium des Gehirns. iv, 35p. 15 pl. 8? Berl., J. Springer, 1929. ---- The same. Brain preparations by means of defibrillation or blunt dissection; a guide to the macroscopic study of the brain; transl. from the 1st German ed. by Herbert J. Wilkinson, ix, 48p. illust. pl. 8? Lond., W. Heinemann, 1935. See also Dahlberg, G. [Obituary] Upsala lak. foren. forh., 1938, 43: No. 5-6, p. i-viii, portr. HUMAN, J. U. The secrets of blind intubation and the signs of anaesthesia, vii, 67p. illust. fold, diagr. 17cm. Lond., J. Bale, sons & Curnow, 1938. HUMAN biology. Bait., v.l, 1929- HUMAN fertility. Bait., v.5, 1940- Continuation of Journal (The) of contraception. HUMANISM. Existe-t-il un humanisme mediterranean? 40p. 23cm. Nice, 1936. Baglioni, S. Umanesimo e medicina. Fisiol. & med., Roma, 1934 5: 1-14.—Desfosses, P. Quelques reflexions sur 1 huma- nisme. Presse med., 1938, 46: 241-3.—Galdston, I. Humanism and pubUc health. Ann. M. Hist., 1941, 3. ser 3: 513-23 — Gregg, A. Humanism and science. BuU. N. York Acad. M., 1941, 17: 83-99.—Herrick. C. J. Neurobiological foundations of modern humanism. Proc. Inst. M. Chicafo, 1936 11• «£ 99.-Human.sm, science and God. Med. J. Australia 1941* 85—Huxley. J S Scientific humanism. In his Man Stands Alone, 2 ed., N. Y., 1941, 256-72.-Rittmeister, J. F. Lues psychotherapeutische Aufgabe und- der neue Humanismus Psychiat. neur. bl Amst.,1936, 40: 777-96.-Schroder.ILE: Das Menschenbild des Dntten Humanismus. Zschr Men- ht»i'™3T3' 13i 16-2L-Jav£s- E- 0n Riser's scientffic humanism. J. Am. Soc. Psychic. Res., 1941, 35: 15-23. HUMANITARIANISM. Faure, M. Les origine de l'humanite\ p.39- 51. 23^cm. Nice, 1935. Association (L') pour la protection internationale de l'huma- nite. Arch med beiges, 1936, 89: 180-90—Desfosses, P. Le role moderne de l'humanisme medical. Presse med 1938 46: 785-7.—Macdonald, E. J. The humanitarian movement Commonhealth, Bost., 1939, 26: 176-9.—Oliver, S. F A word for the lowly men. J. Med., Cincin., 1941-42* 22*• 490 HUMBERSTONE, Engl. Leicestershire and Rutland Lunatic Asylum [1837] Annual report. 2., 1850; 4.-13., 1852-61; 15.-18., 1863-66; 21.-26., 1869-74; 27.-37., 1875-85; 43.-52. 1891-1900. ---■ Rules. 8? [n. pl.] 1849. HUMBERT, Gabriel, 1885- *Contribu- tion a l'histoire de la pharmacie strasbourgeoise [Strasbourg] 424p. 33 pl. 24cm. Mulhouse, J. Brinkmann, 1938. HUMBERT, Gaston, 1902- *Le secret medical dans les nouvelles lois sociales. 70p. 8? Par., M. Vigne, 1929. HUMBERT, Marc Anselme, 1900- Con- tribution a l'etude de la valeur therapeutique de l'operation d'Albee dans le mal de Pott. 54p. 8? Par., L. Arnette, 1929. HUMBERT, Paul, 1912- *Remarques sur la comparaison des elements chimiques et bacteriologiques; d'appr6ciation de la potability des eaux de boisson. 71p. 25cm. Lyon, Lap- lanche, 1938. HUMBERT, Pierre, 1905- *Homosexua- lit6 et psychopathies [Paris] 141p. 8? Cahors, A. Coueslant, 1935. HUMBERT, Roger. Contribution a l'etude des fractures du plateau tibial par l'extension au fil de Kirschner. 36p. 22)^cm. Lausanne, Payot, 1939. HUMBLA, Carl Gustaf Philibert, 1858-1934. W., A. [Obituary] Tskr. mil. hatsov., 1935, 60: 66, portr. HUMBOLDT, Alexander von, 1769-1859. Bolton, S. K. Alexander von Humboldt. In her Famous Men of Sc, N. Y., 1938, 89-114.—Ebstein, E. Aus Alexander von Humboldts Friihzeit; mit zwei unbekannten Dokumenten (1795) Mitt. Gesch. Med. Naturwiss., 1927, 26: 169-72 — Haberling, W. Alexander von Humboldt and Johannes Muller. Med. Life, N. Y., 1928, 35: 529-36.—Stellfeld, C. Humboldt. Tribuna farm., Curitiba, 1942, 10: 9.—Wittich, E. Alexander von Humboldts Expeditionen in Mexiko. KUn. Wschr., 1934, 13: 342-8. HUME, Douglas W., 1882-1929. Obituary. Brit. M. J., 1929, 1: 527. HUME, Edgar Erskine, 1889- The medical book of merit; United States army and navy decorations awarded to medical officers for distinguished service in the World War; com- piled by order of the Surgeon Generals of the Army and Navy. 69p. 8? Wash., Ass. Mil. Surgeons, 1925. ---- Max von Pettenkofer; his theory of the etiology of cholera, typhoid fever and other intestinal diseases, a review of his arguments and evidence, xv, 142p. 8? N. Y., P. B. Hoeber, 1927. •---- How Italy won the Great War; with foreword of Paolo De Vecchi. 28p. 2 1. 8? [n p., n. pub.] 1930. Also Ital. transl. by P. De Vecchi. 35p. 3 pl. 8? N. Y., G. P. Print. co. [1930] HUME 884 HUMERAL ---- A colonial Scottish Jacobite family; the establishment in Virginia of a branch of the Humes of Wedderburn; illustrated by letters and other contemporary documents. 163p. illust. pl. maps. facs. 8? Richmond, Va., Old Dominion press, 1931. ---- George Washington and the Society of the Cincinnati. 31p. illust. 8? Wash., D. C, U. S. Geo. Washington Bicent. Com., 1933. ---- The value of studies in health and sanita- tion in war planning. 18 1, 6 1. 4? [n. p., n. pub.] 1933. ---- The gift of the fund of the Society of the Cincinnati in the state of Virginia to Washington College (now Washington and Lee University) 54p. 8? Richmond, Va., 1935. Reprint from Virginia Mag. Hist. & Biogr., 1934, 42: 1935, 43: ---- The diplomas of the Society of the Cincinnati. 2 1. [4] 15p. pl. 8? N. Y., Am. Hist. Soc, 1935. Reprint from Americana, 1935, 29: ---- Poland and the Society of the Cincin- nati. p.3-23. portr. illust. 8? [n. pl., 1935] Repr. from PoUsh American Rev., 1935, 1: 11-31. ---- Steuben and the Society of the Cincin- nati. 12p. illus. portr. 8? [n. pl., 1935] Repr. from American-German Rev., 1935, 1: 17-9; 54. ---- El Coronel Theodor O'Hara, fue el primer extranjero que derram6 su sangre por la libertad de Cuba. 1 1. fol. Habana, 1936. From Avance, Habana, 1936, 2: No. 181. ---- A proposed treaty of alliance between the Sovereign Order of Malta and the United States of America, 1794. 14p. 8? [Williams- burg, Va.] 1936. Repr. from: Wilham and Mary CoUege Q., 1936, 2 ser., 16:. 222-3. ---- Medical work of the knights hospitallers of Saint John of Jerusalem, xxii, 371p. illust. pl. 26cm. Bait., Johns Hopkins press, 1940. ---- The Golden jubilee of the Association of Military Surgeons of the United States; a history of its first half-century; 1891-1941. xvi p. 7-371p. illust. (incl. portr. facs.) 26cm. Wash.. Ass. Mil. Surgeons, 1941. Repr. from MU. Surgeon, 1941, 89: 247-594. For portrait, photograph, see CoUection in Library. HUME, Edward Hicks, 1876- The Chinese way in medicine. 5 p. 1. 189p. illust. pl. (1 fold.) portr. fold. tab. 20cm. Bait., Johns Hopkins press, 1940. Forms 3. ser., v.4, H. Noguchi lect., Pub. Inst. Hist. M., Bait. HUME, E. Margaret, & CHICK, Harriette. Reports on biological standards. IV: The standardisation and estimation of Vitamin A. 61p. 8? Lond., H. M. Stat. Off., 1935. Gr. Britain. Priv. Counc Med. Res. Counc. Spec. Rep. Ser. No. 202. HUME, Ethel Douglas. B6champ or Pasteur? a lost chapter in the history of biology; founded upon MS. by Montague R. Leverson. 2. ed. 287p. portr. 8? Lond., C. W. Daniel co. [1932] HUME, John R., 1883-1938. Obituary. Tr. Am. Lar. Rhin. Otol. Soc, 1939, 45: 478. Also Tr. Am. Acad. Ophth. Otolar., 1939, 417. HUxME, Norman Haliburton, 1846-1936. Obituary. Lancet, Lond., 1936, 1: 869. HUMELBERGIUS Secundus, Dick, pseud. Apician morsels; or, Tales of the table, kitchen, and larder: containing a new and improved code of eatics; select epicurean precepts; nutritive maxims, reflections, anecdotes [&c] 3 p. 1 212p. front, pl. 18Kcm. N. Y., J. & J. Har- per for Collins & Hannay, 1829. HUMERAL artery. See Brachial artery. HUMERO-RADIAL joint. See under Elbow joint. HUMERUS. See also Arm; Elbow; Elbow joint; Shoulder. Akabori, E. Septal apertures in the humerus in Japanese, Ainu and Koreans. Am. J. Phys. Anthrop., 1934, 18: 39,"> • 400.—Bodel, J. K., jr. Determination of the condylo-diaphy.sial angle of the humerus. Ibid., 1939, 25: 333-9.—Bremer, J. L. The pneumatization of the humerus in the common fowl and the associated activity of theelin. Anat. Rec, 1940, 77: 197-211, 2 pl.—Fiorentini, A. Osservazioni sulla struttura deU'estremitS. superiore deU'omero umano. Riv. biol., 1928, 10: 18-53, pl.—Hrdlicka, A. The humerus: Septal apertures. Anthropologie, Praha, 1932, 10: 31-96, 4 pl. ------ The principal dimensions, absolute and relative, of the humerus in the white race. Am. J. Phys. Anthrop., 1932, 16: 431-50.— P'an, Ming-Tzu. Septal apertures in the humerus in the Chinese. Ibid., 1935, 20: 165-70.—Trotter, M. Septal apertures in the humerus of American whites and Negroes. Ibid., 1934, 19: 213-27. Also repr.—Vallois, H. V. L'humerus des Fudgiens. Anthropologie, Praha, 1932, 10: 113-28, pl. ---- Abnormities. Bachelieb, J. *Contribution a 1'et.ude de 1'ectromelie; l'absence congenitale de l'humerus. 65p. 8? Par., 1928. Marique, P. Aspect radiographique anormal de la t6te humerale. Arch. fr. belg. chir., 1929, 31: 236-8.—Smith, S. A. Congenital absence of the humerus. Brit. J. Surg., 1927-28, 15:385. ---- Calcification and exostosis. Cagny. Exostose de l'humdrus. Bull. Soc centr. mid. vet., Par., 1905, 59: 253-5.—Cucullu. A. C, & Vergnolle, M. Ex6stosis osteogdnica de htimero. Bol. Soc. cir. B. Aires, 1927, 11: 903-11.—Duncker, F. Fraktur einer kartilaginaren Humerusexostose infolge eines Sportunfalles. Zschr. orthop. Chir., 1931, 55: 282-5.—Fahey, J. J., & Harmon, P. H. Calci- fication about the posterior portion of the greater tubercle of the humerus; differentiation from supraspinatus tendon calci- fication. Am. J. Roentg., 1937, 38: 707-10.—Gill, W. G. Diaphyseal aclasis. Proc. R. Soc M., Lond., 1937-38, 31: 11-3.—Lo Cascio, V. Sopra un caso di frattura di esostosi soUtaria borsata. Gazz. internaz. med. chir., 1927, 32: 339- 46. ---- Cancer. Schmid [geb. Fassbender] H. *Ein Endo- theliom des Oberarmknochens [Berlin] 27p. 23cm. Murnau, 1937. Ungar, H. *Ein Fall von subleukamischer lymphocytarer Retikuloendotheliose mit Ueber- gang in retikuloendotheliales Sarkom des Hume- rus. p.59-81. 8? Berl., 1933. Blagdon, L. Fracture pathologique de l'humerus envahi par une tumeur mdtastatique secondaire k un dpithdlioma primitif-du sein. Union med. Canada, 1937, 66: 355.—Braine, J. A propos de la nature histologique et de l'origine mdtasta- tique (tumeur mahgne cortico-surrdnale) de la lesion de l'ex- tremite superieure de l'humdrus, Mdm. Acad, chir., Par., 1935, 61: 1449-54.— Ciburas, I. [Hypernephroma humeri dextri metastaticum] Medicina, Kaunas, 1941,22:112-4.—D'Allaines, F., Contiades, X. J., & Naulleau, J. Observation suivie pendant 6 ans d'un angioendothdliome ddveloppd dans la gouttidre des vaisseaux humdraux; 2 rdcidives postopdratoires; transforma- tion sarcomateuse. Bull. Soc. nat. chir., Par., 1935, 61: 1134-42.—Dionisi, H. Consideraciones sobre la evoluci6n de un tumor a cdlulas gigantes de la extremidad inferior del humero. Bol. Soc. cir. B. Aires, 1935, 19: 1118-30.—Eliason, E. L. Angio-endothelioma of the humerus. Ann. Surg., 1931, 93: 1243-5.—Finsterbusch, R., & Schumann, G. Vol- Uger Schwund eines Oberarmknochens durch osteoklastische Karzinommetastase. Rontgenpraxis, 1937, 9: 318-23.— Flecker, H. Tumour of humerus (Ewing's endothelioma) Med. J. Austraha, 1927, 1: 835.—Lasserre, C. Tumeurs k ceUules gdantes, traitdes par 6videment suivi de greffes. Bor- deaux chir., 1936, 7: 428.—Lecene, P. Un cas de chlorome de l'extremite superieure de l'humdrus traite par la resection dtendue; gudrison maintenue au bout de 11 mois. Bull. Soc. nat. chir., Par., 1927, 53: 1328-31.—Mallory, T. B. Giant-ceU tumor of humerus. N. England J. M., 1942, 226: 571-3.— Montant, R., & Perrier, C. Disarticulation interscapulo- thoracique pour mdtastase d'hypernephrome de l'humerus droit, ndphrectomie secondaire. Rev. med. Suisse rom., 1941, 61: 170-5.-—Nicolini. Sarcoma de Ewing del liumero; resec- ci6n; injerto. Bol. Soc. cir. B. Aires, 1937, 21: 1077-9.— Peabody, P. D. Giant cell tumor of the humerus; report of a HUMERUS 885 HUMERUS case. Tr. West. Surg. Ass. (1938) 1939, 48: 519-28.—Shimada, T. Eine grosse Strumametastase im rechten Humerus, welche mit Myeloidsarkom verwechselt und operiert wurde. Zbl. Chir., 1933, 60: 449. ---- Capitellum. Billi, A. Sul meccanismo di frattura dell'eminenza capitata deU'omero. Chir. org. movim., 1935-36, 21: 10-20.—Chiariello, A. G. La frattura dell'eminenza capitata deU'omero. Ann. ital. chir., 1930, 9: 263-70.—Christopher, F., & Bushnell, L. F. Conservative treatment of fracture of the capitellum. J. Bone Surg., 1935, 17: 489-92.—Ciaccia, S. La frattura dell'emi- nenza capitata deU'omero. Chir. org. movim., 1929, 14: 181-99 —Fitzgerald, H. W. Fracture of the capitellum. Australas. N. Zealand J. Surg., 1934-35, 4: 414-7.—Gejrot, W. On intra-articular fractures of the capitellum and trochlea of the humerus with special reference to the treatment. Acta chir. scand., 1932, 71: 253-70.—Hopkins, F. S. Fracture of the capitellum. N. England J. M., 1932, 206: 1261-3 — Lee W. E., & Summey, T. J. Fracture of the capiteUum of the humerus. Ann. Surg., 1934, 99: 497-509.—Mazel, M. S. Fracture of the capitellum; a report of a case. J. Bone Surg., 1935 17: 483-8.—Osteochondritis of the capiteUum. Proc. R. Soc. M., Lond., 193.5-36, 29: 1660-2.—Robertson, R. C, & Bogart, F. B. Fracture of the capitellum and trochlea, com- bined with fracture of the external humeral condyle. J. Bone Surg., 1933, 15: 206-13.—Vallone, D. A proposito della frattura dell'eminenza capitata deU'omero. Chir. org. movim., 1929, 14: 607. ---- Capitulum. See also subheading Osteoporosis. Chutro, P. De resecci6n de cabeza humeral y reposici6n de un segmento de la misma. In his Lecc. clin. quir., B. Air., 1938, 3: 17-25.—Decoulx, P., & Demarez, R. Luxation- fracture de la tete humdrale. Echo mdd. nord, 1934, 2. ser., 2: 44-7.—Domrich, H. Ueber Dauerergebnisse bei der Behand- lung von Oberarmkopfbruchen. Chirurg, 1931, 3: 604-13.— Fasiani, G. M. Paralisi tardiva del nervo cubitale consecutiva a frattura del capitulum humeri; trasposizione del nervo; guarigione. Minerva med., Tor., 1926, 6: 534-9.—Hussein, M. K. Separation of capitulum of humerus in chUdhood and neuritis of ulnar nerve several years after. J. Egypt. M. Ass., 1934, 17: 502-11.—Jones, L. Reconstructive operation for non-reducible fractures of the head of the humerus. Ann. Surg., 1933, 97: 217-25.—Leo, E. Riproduzione deUe testa omerale distaccata da trauma e chirurgicamente asportata. Arch. Soc. ital. chir., 1936, 42: 669-76.—Milch, H. Unusual fractures of the capitulum humeri and the capitulum radn. J. Bone Surg., 1931, 13: 882-6.—Nielsen, N. A. Osteochondritis dissecans capituU humeri (Untersuchungen an 168 Fallen) Acta ortho- paed. scand., 1933, 4: 307-457.—Panner, H. J. Separations from the capitulum humeri as the most frequent determining cause of arthritis deformans cubiti. Acta radiol., Stockh., 1924, 3: 129-56, 3 pl.—Sever, J. W. Fracture of the head of the humerus; treatment and results. Tr. N. England Surg. Soc, 1936, 19: 254-78. Also N. England J. M., 1937, 216: HOO-7.— Trottier, E. A propos d'un cas de rdsection de la tdte de 1 humd- rus. J. Hotel Dieu Montrdal, 1933, 2: 368772.—Voss, O. Nagelung von Oberarmkopfbruchen. Beitr. kUn. Chir., 1935, 181- 669 ------ Operation und Nagelung des Humerus- kopfbruches. Ibid., 162: 190-200. --- Condyle. Busch, E. [Case of Panner's disease] Ugeskr. lager, 1930, 92: 720 pl—Cornejo Sera via, E. Seudo-artrosis del cOndilo esterno humeral. Bol. Soc. cir. B. Aires, 1936, 20: 893-5.— Krebs, C. Maladie de Panner: une affection du condyle de l'humdrus ressemblant k la maladie de Calve-Perthes (de l'articulation coxo-fdmorale) Arch. fr. belg. chir, 1927, 30: 608—Mouchet, A. Le ddcalottement du condyle humeral. Presse mdd., 1929, 37: 1677.—Ottolenghi, C. E. Osteocondrosis del c6ndilo externo del humero. Bol. Soc. cir. B. Aires, 1939, 23. 1120 ------ & Gamboa, M. Osteocondrosis del cOndilo externo del humero. Ibid., 1044-51.—Rivarola, J. E. Osteo- condrosis del c6ndilo externo del humero; enfermedad de Pan- ner Ibid 1007-13.—Rocher, H. L. Ddcalottement du condyle externe; corps dtranger articulaire; extirpation par arthrotomie minima, sous anesthdsie locale; gudrison. J. med. Bordeaux, 1938, 115: pt 2, 596—Ruiz Moreno, M. Osteo- condrosis del c6ndi!o externo del humero; enfermedad de Fan- ner. Bol. Soc. cir. B. Aires, 1939, 23: 1085-7.—Voshe 1. A. F., & Raylor, K. P. A. Regeneration of the lateral condyle of the humerus after excision. J. Bone Surg., 1939, 21: 421-4. ---- Condyle: Fracture. Ceccaldi, M. A. indications et technique op6ratoire de l'osteosynthese pour les fractures du condyle externe de l'humerus [Pans] 52p. 8? Orleans, 1931. . , 1>/A , , Gtjillon, E. V. P. Contribution a 1 etude de certaines fractures rares du condyle de l'humdrus. 76p. 8? Par., 1934. Kempe, O. E. *Frakturen der Trochlea humeri; Behandlung und Ergebnisse [Leipzig] 27p. 23^cm. Zeulenroda i. Thfir., 1937. Micatjd, P. *Les fractures isol6es du condyle humdral; fractures par ddcalottement de mouchet. 83p. 25^cm. Lyon, 1938. Walter, C. [W.] *Frakturen des Condylus externus humeri und ihre Spatschadigungen am Nervus ulnaris. 28p. 8? Bresl., 1931. Beccari, E. Osservazioni su di un caso di frattura parziale del condilo omerale, con rara associazione di altre lesioni trau- matiche del gomito. Arch, ortop., Milano, 1934, 50: 853-75 — Berkhina, F. O. [Isolated fractures of the condvles of the humerus] Ortop. travmat., 1936, 10: 49-65.—Bressot, E. Paralysie cubitale tardive consdeutive k une fracture ancienne du condyle externe de l'humdrus. Bull. Soc. nat. chir., Par., 1933, 59: 64-70.—Broglio, R. La sutura fibro-periostea nelle fratture del condilo esterno deU'omero. Chir. org. movim., 1933-34, 18: 116-8.—Cauvy, J. Les fractures du condvle externe de l'humdrus chez l'enfant. Gaz. mdd. France, 1937, 44: 801-3.—Celiberti, A. Frattura diacondiloidea deU'omero sinistro con spostamento non comune del frammento. PoU- clinico, 1925, 32: sez. prat., 1315-8.—Charbonnel. Ddcortica- tion traumatique du condyle humdral. Bordeaux chir., 1936, 7: 427.—Czembirek, L. Ueber den isolierten Abbruch des Capitulum und der Trochlea humeri. Zbl. Chir., 1939, 66: 1086-91.—Dahl-Iversen, F. Fracture condyhenne humdrale interne. Lyon chir., 1936, 33: 234-8.—Denis, R. Fracture condylienne humdrale, synthase au magndsium. Ibid., 1935, 32: 713-5.—Desgouttes, L., & Denis, R. Les paralysies tardives du cubital k la suite des fractures du condyle externe de l'humd- rus. Presse mdd., 1927, 35: 868.—Dickson, J. A., & Graves, C. L. Condylar fractures of the humerus. Cleveland CUn. Q., 1936, 3: 257-67.—Dunet. C. Fracture du condyle externe de l'humdrus; rdposition et synthese par voie trans-articulaire. J. Egypt. M. Ass., 1934, 17: 532-4.—Dunlop, J. Treatment of intracondylar and supracondylar fracture of the humerus in children by traction. Tr. West. Surg. Ass. (1927) 1928, 37: 97-103. ------ Transcondylar fractures of the humerus in childhood. J. Bone Surg., 1939, 21: 59-73.—Dupuy de Frenelle & Dhotel, H. Traitement opdratoire d'une fracture de l'ex- trdmitd infdrieure de l'humdrus avec divulsion des condyles. Paris chir., 1928, 20: 65-74.—Fredet, P. Fracture isolde de la ldvre interne de la trochlde humdrale (varidtd de la fracture dite de Laugier) Mdm. Acad, chir., Par., 1935, 61:1470.—Fruchaud. De la voie transoldcranienne au sujet d'une fracture du condyle nterne de l'humerus opdrde. Bull. Soc. nat. chir., Par., 1925, 51: 574-81.—Garavano, P. H. Fracturas del c6ndilo externo del humero en los nifios. Dia mdd., B. Air., 1938, 10: 1038-41. Also Rev. ortop. traumat., B. Air., 1939, 8:105-12.—Griseri, V. Frattura omerale diacondiloidea. Chir. org. movim., 1932-33, 17: 359-64.—Guerin, R. Paralysie cubitale survenue 35 ans apres une fracture du condyle externe de l'humdrus. Bordeaux chir., 1935, 6: 239. Also J. mdd. Bordeaux, 1935, 112: 109 — Heyl, J. H. Fracture of the external condyle of the humerus in children. Ann. Surg., 1935, 101: 1069-77— Inclan, A. De- capitation del c6ndilo humeral; una rara variedad de fractura del codo. Cir. ortop. traumat., Habafia, 1938, 6: 159-66.— Johannssen, K. Behandlung und Spatresultate bei schweren Bruchen des Humerusgelenkfortsatzes Erwachsener. Mschr. Unfallh., 1937, 44: 65-84.—Judet, H. Ndvralgie tardive du nerf cubital consdeutive k une fracture du condyle externe de l'humdrus. Bull. Soc. chir. Paris, 1929, 21: 651-4. ------ Luxation ancienne du coude en arridre compliqude de fracture du condyle externe; reposition par la voie trans-oldcranienne de la luxation et de la fracture; rdsultat au bout de 6 mois. Ibid., 1931, 23: 325-9.—Kini, M. G. Fractures of the lateral condyle of the lower end of the humerus with complications; a simple technique for closed reduction of capitellar fracture. J. Bone Surg., 1942, 24: 270-80.—Lagoutte & Rousselin, L. Deux cas de paralysie tardive du cubital consdeutives k des fractures du condyle externe de l'humdrus. Lyon chir., 1935, 32: 239.— LeCocq, J. F. Intercondylar fracture of the elbow; a case report. West. J. Surg., 1936, 44: 658-60.—Lemberg. D. A. [Late paralysis of the cubital nerve following fracture of the external condyle of the humerus] Khirurgia, Moskva, 1938, No 6 135-7.—Maia, B. Fratura do condilo externo do humero. Brasil med., 1942, 56: 61.—Massart, R., & Cabouat. Les fractures du condyle externe chez l'enfant; dtude chnique et radiographique de ces fractures et de leurs resultats dloignds. Rev. orthop., Par., 1928, 3. ser., 15: 475-96—Mathieu, P. Fractures du condyle externe de l'humdrus chez 1 enfant traitdes par vissage. Bull. Soc. nat. chir., Par., 1926, 52: 689 — Nicolis, N. Frattura diacondiloidea dell'estremo inferiore dell omero. Atti Congr. ital. radiol. med., 1922, 4: 186-9.—Ottolenghi, C. E., & Lagomarsino, E. H. Fractura del condilo humeral externo en el nino; reduction incruenta. Rev. ortop. traumat., B Air., 1936-37, 6: 279-86.—Pollosson & Arnulf. Fracture du condyle interne; reposition sanglante. Lyon chir., 1937, 34: 337-40—Racugno, L. Sulle fratture isolate condiloidee e diacondiloidee dell'estremo inferiore deU'omero e loro esiti. Arch, ortop., Milano, 1937, 53: 255-88—Reich, R. S. Treat- ment of intercondylar fractures of the elbow by means of trac- tion. J. Bone Surg., 1936. 18: 997-1004.-Rendu, A. Sur le ddcalottement du condyle humdral. Rev. orthop , Par., 1925, 3. ser. 12:445-61.—Ritter, C. Zur operativen Behandlung dea HUMERUS 886 HUMERUS Abbruchs der Humerus-Gelenkrolle. Arch. klin. Chir., 1931, 164: 090-6.—Roberts. N. Fractures of the external condyle and capitellum of the lower end of the humerus. Liverpool Med. Chir. J., 1936, 44: 1-16, pl. ------ Fractures of the external condvle and capitellum of the humerus. Clin. J., Lond., 1936, 65: 484-91.—Rocher, H. L., & Guerin, R. Ostdo- synthdsc temporaire au poincon dans les fractures du condyle externe chez l'enfant. Bordeaux chir., 1930, 1: 297. Also J. mdd. Bordeaux, 1930, 107: 141-4.—Rocher, H. L., & Pou- yanne, L. Luxation du coude avec fracture du condyle externe de l'humerus. Bordeaux chir., 1935, 6: 243. Also J. mdd. Bordeaux, 1935, 112: 403. ------ & Jeanneney. Ddcalotte- ment condylo-troclilccn; extirpation. Bordeaux chir., 1934, 5: 296.—Rocher, H. I... & Rioux, G. La rdposition sanglante simple dans les fractures du condyle externe humdral k grand emplacement chez l'enfant. Arch. fr. belg. chir., 1926, 29: 86- 91.—Rocher, H. L., & Rocher, C. Un cas atypique de ddcalotte- ment du condyle lmnidral (fracture intraarticulaire du flanc externe du condyle) J. mdd. Bordeaux, 1935, 112: 397.— Roederer. Rdsultats ddplorables de 2 fractures du condyle humdral incorrectement traitdes. Bull. Soc. chir. Paris, 1929, 21: 163-71.—Saitta, S. Paralisi tardive del nervo ulnare da frattura del condilo esterno. Ann. med. nav. col., Roma, 1933, 39: pt 2, 454-69.—Salarich Torrents, J. Fractura del c6ndilo interno del humero (caso cUnico) Ars medica, Barcel., 1928. 4: 233-7.—Saner, F. D. Transcondylar fractures of the humerus in children. Lancet, Lond., 1926, 2: 901; 1928, 1: 698 — Sicard, A. Ddcalottement du condyle humdral. Rev. orthop., Par., 1928, 3. ser., 15: 340-4.—Slanina, P. Fracture du condyle externe de l'humdrus droit avec rotation du fragment en dehors et en avant compliqude de pardsie du nerf radial; ablation chirurgicale du fragment; rdgdndration du condyle, ibid., 1926, 3. ser., 13: 227-30.—Smith. M. K. Fractures of the external condyle of the humerus with rotation. Ann. Surg., 1927, 86: 304-7.—Sorrel, E. Paralysie tardive du nerf cubital survenue 20 ans aprds une fracture du condyle externe de l'humdrus. Bull. Soc. nat. chir., Par., 1933, 59: 193-6.—Speed, J. S., & Macey. H. B. Fractures of the humeral condyles in children. J. Bone Surg., 1933, 15: 903-19.—Tailhefer, A. Fractures du condyle interne et fractures sus-condyliennes incompldtes de l'humdrus chez l'enfant. Presse mdd., 1926, 34: 21.—Vallone, D. Le fratture del condilo esterno dell'epifisi inferiore deU'omero e loro trattamento chirurgico. Ann. ital. chir., 1925, 4: 545- 63.—Violate, A. Le paraUsi tardive del cubitale consecutive a frattura del condilo esterno deU'omero. Ann. med. nav., Roma, 1927, 1: 314-39.—Wilson, P. I). Fracture of the lateral condyle of the humerus in childhood. J. Bone Surg., 1936, 18:301-18.— Zadek, I. Fracture of medial epicondyle of the humerus with its displacement into the sigmoid cavity of the ulna; report of 2 cases. Am. J. Surg., 1925, 39: 217-9. ---- Cyst. Krafft, E. *Ueber Knochencysten am Oberarm und ihre Behandlung. 23p. 22cm. Konigsb., 1935. Define, D. Kysto soUtario do humerus curado expontanea- mente. Ann. paul. med. cir., 1938, 36: 583-7.—Di Cianni, E. Sopra un caso di frattura deU'omero da cisti ossea vera sohtaria. Rinasc. med., 1934, 11: 200-2.—Ducrey, E. Solitare Knochen- cyste des Humerus, geheilt durch Auskratzung und Einpflan- zung eines Tibiaspanes. Deut. Zschr. Chir., 1936, 247:530-4.— Fairchild, R. D. Benign bone cyst; a report of 3 cases locaUzed in the humerus. Am. J. Surg., 1936, 32: 126-9.—Gauillard. Kvstes osseux de la tdte de l'humdrus. Bull. Soc. radiol. mdd. France, 1926, 14: 143-5.—Guyot, J. Sur un cas de kyste de l'extrdmitd supdrieure de l'humdrus. Progr. mdd., Par., 1936, 1250-7.—Hungria, S., & Amaral, Z. Ueber einen Fall von fibrbser Cyste des Humerus mit spontanem nachfolgenden Bruch, geheilt durch Einpflanzung eines aus dem Peroneum entnommenen Knochenstiickes. Zbl. Chir., 1927, 54: 2706-9.— Mathieu, P. Un cas de kyste osseux volumineux de l'extrdmitd supdrieure de l'humdrus. Mdm. Acad, chir., Par., 1936, 62: 1430.—Merz, M. Tumeur bdnigne kystique de l'extrdmitd supdrieure de l'humerus et fractures itdratives. Lyon chir., 1932, 29: 598.—Montant, R. Greffe d'os purum dans un cas de kyste solitaire de l'humdrus. Schweiz. med. Wschr., 1939, 69: 386.—Oudard. Deux cas de kystes essentiels de l'humdrus opdrds. Rev. orthop., Par., 1930, 3. ser., 17: 37-43.—Simpson- Smith, A. Spontaneous fracture of humerus; sohtary cyst. Tr. M. Soc. London, 1930, 53: 73.—Taddei, D. Ciste ossea deU'omero. Rass. internaz. cUn. ter., 1933, 14: 1084-100. ---- Disease. Adams. A. W. Report of a case of sohtary fibrocystic disease of the humerus exhibiting spontaneous resolution; with a review of the Uterature and a consideration of the eti- ology and treatment. Brit. J. Surg., 1925-26, J3: 734-41.— Berger, J. Maladie kystique de l'humdrus. BuU. Soc. nat. chir., Par., 1929, 55: 321.—Buxton, S. J. D. Two cases of fibro- cystic disease of the humerus, treated by different methods Proc. R. Soc. M., Lond., 1927-28, 21: Sect. Orthop., 11-6.— Cuneo. Ostdite kystique du l'extremitd supdrieure de l'humd- rus. Bull. Soc. nat. chir., Par., 1934, 60: 923.—Desplats, R. Rdsultats dloignds, 10 ans aprds, de la radiothdrapie dans un cas d'osteite grave de la tete humdrale. J. sc. mdd. Lille, 1930 48: J6.5-9. pl. [Discussion] 172,—Frankhau, C. H. S. Fibrocystic disease of the humerus. Proc. R. Soc. M., Lond., 1927-28, 21: sect, chn., 52.—Hadley, R. Sclerosis and periostitis of the humerus. Med. .1. Australia, 1941, 2: 213.—Hermann. K. Brodie-Abszess. Med. Welt, 1929, 3: 889.—Mjajor. It. C. Lesions of the upper humerus. Radiology, 1931, 16:221 31. - Santy, P. Opdration iterative pour osteite kystique de lliume- rus. Lyon chir., 1933, 30: 308- Shattock. ('. E. Case for diagnosis; ? gummatous osteitis of the humerus. Proc. R. Soc. M., Lond., 1928-29. 22: Sect. Clin., 9.—Nilhol. J. Ostdite ddformante de l'extremite superieure de l'humdrus. Bull. Soc. chir., Par., 1921, 47: 191 -0. Wakeley, C. P. G. A case of chronic abscess in the shaft of the humerus. Proc. R. Soc. M., Lond., 1928-29, 22: Sect. Clin., 30. ---- Echinococcus. Diez, J. Equinococosis de humero; resecci6n e injerto; curaci6n. Bol. Soc. cir. B. Aires, 1938, 22: 60.5-15.—Gernez. Humdrectomie totale pour dchinococcose de l'humdrus gauche; rdsultat fonctionnel et appareillage aprds seize mois. Bull. Soc. nat. chir., Par., 1933, 59: 1323-8.—Mazzini, O. F. Con- solidaci6n de las fracturas del humero por quisles hidatfdicos. Bof. Soc. cir. B. Aires, 1931, 15: 729-45. Also Rev. sudamer. endoer., B. Air., 1931, 14: 653-68— Petridis. P. Un cas de kystes hydatiques multiloculaircs et suppurds de l'humdrus droit; opdrations successives; gudrison. Bull. Soc. nat. chir., Par., 1926, 52: 1070-8.—Thierolf, R. Zusammenhangsfrage zwischen Oberarmfraktur und Echinococcusansiedlung. Mschr. Unfallh., 1934, 41: 248-51. ---- Epicondyle. Brandesky, W. Ueber den Epicondvlusschmerz. Deut. Zschr. Chir., 1929, 219: 246-56.—Crillovich, R. Ein Beitrag zur pathologischen Knochenneubildung am .Epicondylus medialis humeri. Arch, orthop. UnfaUchir., 1927, 25: 600-5.— Hamilton, A. R. A case of calcification in the epicondylar bursa at the elbow. Brit. J. Surg., 1938-39, 26: 446-8.—Villegas Ruiz, J. de D. La epicondilalagia. Gac. mdd. Caracas, 1925, 32: 341. ---- Epicondyle: Fracture. Gence, R. *Fracture de l'dpitrochlde avec interposition du fragment dans l'articulation et son traitement. 57p. 8? Par., 1925. Aitken, A. P., & Childress, H. M. Intra-articular displace- ment of the internal epicondyle following dislocation. J. Bone Surg., 1938, 20: 161-6.—Cahuzac, M., & Courty, E. Subluxa- tion postdro-externe de l'articulation du coude avec fracture de l'dpitrochlde et interposition de ce fragment dans l'interlignr articulaire; rdduction par manoeuvres externes. Mem. Acad. chir., Par., 1939, 65: 146-51.—Calissano, G. Frattura dell'epi- troclea con interposizione del frammento epitrocl'eare nell'arti- colazione. Minerva med., Tor., 1931, 22: &32-5.—Dunlop, J. Traumatic separation of the medial epicondyle of the humerus in adolescence. J. Bone Surg., 1935, 17: 577-87. ----- Elbow injuries of childhood resulting from median epicondylar separations. Am. J. Surg., 1939, 43: 310-24.—Fairbank, H. A. T., & Buxton, J. D. Displacement of the internal epicondyle into the elbow-joint. Lancet, Lond., 1934, 2: 218.—Fevre, M. La rdduction par manoeuvres exQinteternes des positions de l'dpitrochlde dans l'interligne articulaire du coude; 2 nouveaux cas reduits sans intervention sanglante. Mdm. Acad, chir., Par., 1938, 64: 692-9. ■-----& Roudaitis. La reduction non sanglante des fractures de l'dpitrochlde avec interposition de ce fragment dans l'interligne articulaire du coude. Rev. orthop., Par., 1933, 20: 300-15— Forgue, Mourgue-MoUnes & Villa. Fracture de l'dpitrochlde; diastasis articulaire;. interposition du fragment dpitrochlden dans l'articulation. Bull. Soc. sc. mdd. biol. Montpellier, 1924-25, 6: 357-60.—Frisch, O. Abriss des Epicondylus medialis humeri; operation. Wien. med. Wschr., 1927, 77: 1627.—Gr. Abriss des K-nochenkerns des Epicondylus medialis humeri mit Einklemmung in das Gelenk. Rontgenpraxis, 1933, 5: 699.—Grauhan, M., & Mauss, H. G. Der Abriss des Epicondylus medialis. Zbl. Chir., 1938, 65: 2311-8.—Grimault, L. Fracture de l'dpi- trochlde avec interposition du fragment entre la trochlde et la cavitd sigmoide; paralysie du nerf cubital; ostdosynthdse. Bull. Soc. nat. chir., Par., 1928, 54: 988-93.—Hamant & Bodart. Trois cas de fracture de l'dpitrochlde avec interposi- tion dont l'une avec paralysie cubitale. Rev. 'orthop.. Par., 1933, 20: 144-7.—Hamant, Chalnot & Guyot. Les fractures de l'dpitrochlde et leurs complications. Rev. mdd. est, 1934, 66: 469-88.—Higgs, S. L. Fractures of the internal epicondyle of the humerus. Brit. M. J., 1936, 2: 000, pl.—Iotti, G. Con- tributo al trattamento cruento nei distaceo della epitroclea. Policlinico, 1928, 35: sez. prat., 337-43.- Ivakhenko, G. S. [Gangrene of the fingers following fracture of the epicondyle of the humerus] Khirurgia, Moskva, 1938, No. 4, 165-7, pl.— Lagos Garcia, A. Fractura de la epitr6clea con interposici6n intraarticular del fragmento; pardhsis del nervio cubital. Bol. Soc. cir., B. Aires, 1933, 17: 1060-4. ------ Fractura de la epitr6clea con interposici6n articular del fragmento; reducoi6n incruenta. Ibid., 1935, 19: 277-83.—Lasserre, C, k Dotezac. G. Le traitement chirurgical des fractures de lepitrochlee chez l'enfant. J. mdd. Bordeaux, 1938, 115: pt 2, 041-4. - Mancini, G. Fratture isolate dell'epitroclea. Chir. org. movim., 1930-37, 22: 473-8.—Massart, R. Ankylose du coude HUMERUS 887 HUMERUS par fragment dpitrochlden enciavd depuis 6 mois et adhdrent; arthrotomie k travers 1'oldcrane et restitution compldte des mouvements. Bull. Soc. chir. Paris, 1929, 21: 737-43.— Mayer, J. H. A case of fractured medial epicondyle of the humerus with displacement inside the elbow joint. Guy's Hosp. Gaz., Lond., 1938, 52: 239-41.—Outland, T. A. Pos- terior dislocation of the elbow; complicated by fracture of the medial epicondyle and ulnar neuritis; case report. Bull. Guthrie Clin., 1937-38, 7: 106. ------ & Hanlon, C. R. Posterior dislocation of the elbow joint complicated by fracture of the medial epicondvle and ulnar-nerve injury. J. Bone Surg., 1938, 20: 750-3.—Perrotti, G. Le fratture isolate dell'epitroclea e loro cura chirurgica. Riforma med., 1929, 45: 1517-9.—Querneau, J. Luxation du coude; inclusion de l'dpitrochlde; paralysie cubitale; intervention tardive; gudrison. Mdm. Acad, chir., Par., 1938, 64: 1421-3.—Roberts, N. W. Displacement of the internal epicondyle into the elbow-joint; 4 cases successfully treated by manipulation. Lancet, Lond., 1934, 2: 78.—Rocher, H. L. L'inclusion articulaire de l'dpi- trochlde au cours des luxations du coude; l'osteosvnthese au poincon. Rev. mdd. fr., 1931, 12: 683-92—Rossi. F. Lussa- zione del gomito e frattura dell'epitroclea. CUn. chir., Milano, 1928, 31: 577-93.—Simeon, A., & Renon, C. Un nouveau cas de fracture marginale infdrieure de l'dpitrochlde chez l'adulte. J. mdd. Bordeaux, 1939, 116: pt 2, 383.—Smith, E. J. R. De- tachment of the medial epicondyle of the humerus with dis- placement into the elbow-joint. Brit. J. Surg., 1938-39, 26: 785-90.—Sorrel, E.. Bret, J., & Debouvry, J. Quatre cas de luxation du coude irrdductible par inclusion de l'dpitrochlde et du tendon des muscles dpitrochldens. Mdm. Acad, chir., Par., 1938, 64: 87-96.—Stulz, E. Luxation du coude en arridre avec fracture de l'dpitrochlde, engagement du fragment osseux dans l'interligne articulaire. Bull. Soc. anat. Paris, 1924, 94: 417-20.—Stupochenko, G. M. [Errors and dangers in treat- ment of epicondylian fractures of the humerus] Khirurgia, Moskva, 1939, No. 5, 102.—Tierny, A. Luxation du coude irrdductible par inclusion de l'dpitrochlde. Mdm. Acad, chir., Par., 1938, 64: 150-2.—Tillier, H. Rdduction sous dcran radioscopique d'une luxation du coude avec interposition de l'dpitrochlde ddcollde. Rev. orthop., Par., 1939, 26: 63-7 — Torchiana, L. Considerazioni su un caso di distaceo traumatico dell'epitroclea con intraposizione articolare del frammento e sub-lussazione antero-laterale del gomito. Minerva med., Tor., 1929, 9: 149-52.—Vails. A proposito de fractura de la epitr6clea con interposition intraarticular del fragmento; reducci6n incruenta. Bol. Soc. cir. B. Aires, 1935, 19: 299- 302.—Walker, H. B. A case of dislocation of the elbow with separation of the internal epicondyle and displacement of the latter into the joint cavity. Brit. J. Surg., 1927-28, 15: 677- 9.—Zeno, L. Fractura de la epitroclea con interposicidn intra- articular del fragmento; paraUsis del nervio cubital. Bol. Soc. cir. B. Aires, 1933, 17: 1259-62. --- Epicondylitis [Tennis-elbow] Dtjpuis, L. *Ueber die Behandlung der Epikondyhtis humeri lateralis [Kiel] 12p. 21cm. Hamb., 1938. KinktjlkIn, A. *L'epicondylite. 44p. 8? Par., 1937. Koller, A. *Die Epicondylitis humeri an Hand von 97 Fallen der Schweizerischen Unfall- versicherungsanstalt Luzern [Zurich] 36p. Zug, 1928. Wagner, E. *TJeber Epicondylitis humeri. 40p. 8? Heidelb., 1927. Bellin du Coteau. Contribution k 1'dtude du tennis elbow. Vie mdd., 1926, 7: 907-9.—Bergmann, E. Epikondyhtis. Arch, orthop. UnfaUchir., 1924, 23: 368-74.—Boshamer, K. Ueber die EpicondyUtis humeri (Tennisellbogen) und andere Periostalgien. Munch, med. Wschr., 1934, 81: 870.—Carp, L. Tennis elbow (epicondylitis) caused by radiohumeral bursitis; anatomic, clinical, roentgenologic and pathologic aspects, with a suggestion as to tieatment. Arch. Surg., 1932, 24: 905-22.— Chavannaz, J., & Marjou, L. L'dpicondyUte des sportifs. Rev. chir., Par., 1938, 76: 126-41.—Cluzet, J. Sur l'dpicondy- lite et son traitement par les agents physiques. Arch, dlectr. mdd., 1926, 36: 190.—Cones, W. P. Epicondylitis (Franke) or tennis elbow. Boston M. & S. J., 1914, 170: 461-5. Also repr.—Conzette. Essai de pathogdnie de l'dpicondyhte des joueurs de tennis et des escrimeurs. Presse mdd., 1931, 39: 1167.—Cyriax, J. H. The pathology and treatment of tennis elbow. J. Bone Surg., 1936, 18: 921-40. Also repr. -Dittrich, R. J. Radiohumeral bursitis (tennis elbow) report of 2 cases. Am. J. Surg., 1929, 7: 411-4.—Ferrero. V. L'epicondihtc deU'omero. Arch, ortop., Milano, 1928, 44: 740-59.—Frey, E. Epikondyhtis durch Quarzlampenbestrahlung geheilt wurde. Wien. med. Wschr., 1928, 78: 548. ------ Zur Behandlung der Epikondyhtis. Ibid., 1928. 78: 764-66.—Glass, E. Beitrag zur sogenannten Epicondvlitis humeri (Sport.verletzung, Selbst- beobachtung) Zbl. Chir., 1929,56: 724-0.—Halla, F. Tenms- arm-Epikondylitis. Miinch. med. Wschr., 1936, 83: 149.— Hanak, F. [Tennis elbow] Bratisl. lek. listy, 1937. 17: 430r 9.—Hansson, K. G., & Horwich, I. D. Epicondylitis humeri. J. Am. M. Ass., 1930, 94: 1557-61.—Hohmann Leber den TenniseUbogen. Verh. Deut. orthop. Ges., 21. Kongr. (1926) 1927, 349-55 —— Das Wesen und die Behandlung des |O01e2%nn2te\Tne»^sellenbogens. Munch, med. Wschr., !933 80. 250-2.—Knoll W. Ellenbogenbefunde bei hervorragenden lennisspielern Deut. med. Wschr., 1932, 58: 84-6 Also Schweiz. med. Wschr., 1932, 62: 640.-Leriche, R. A propos du traitement par infiltration novocainique de l'dpicondyhte des r,nUeu»l .. terims; certaines fractures. Presse mdd., 1936 44: 99.—Marlin T. Treatment of tennis elbow with some observa- tions on joint manipulation. Lancet, Lond., 1930 1 • 509-11 — Massart R. L'dpicondyhte des joueurs de tennis' et son traite- ment. Presse mdd., 1935, 43: 1929. ------ A propos du traitement de l'dpicondyhte des joueurs de tennis. Ibid., 1936 44: 200.—Mastromarino. A. Sulla cosidetta epicondihte omerale. Arch, ortop., Milano, 1937, 53: 133-69 ------ A proposito dell'impiego dei raggi roentgen nei trattamento dell epicondihte. Ibid., 497-503.—Mau, C. Die Behandlung der Epicondylitis humeri. Chirurg, 1931, 3: 5-8.—Merlini A L epicondihte omerale. Arch, ortop., Milano, 1928, 44: 546- ; ™TMi"p' G- P- Treatment of tennis elbow. Brit. M J , i2 7-f 2;^?' Als0 Lancet. Lond- 1937, 2: 581. Also Ulster M. J., 1937, 6: 264.—Minami, M. Two cases of the tennis i ™' tt?P' J' M' Sc" 1934-36. 4: Surg. &c, 320.—Perelman, I. M. [Epicondylitis humeri] Nov. khir., Moskva, 1926 3 200-4.—Purrucker, K. Epicondylitis humeri und Unfall" Arch, orthop. UnfaUchir., 1930-31, 29: 548-54.—Schmitt, J. Bursitis calcarea am Epicondylus externus humeri; ein Beitrag zur Pathogenese der Epicondylitis. Ibid., 1921, 19: 215-21.— Slowick, F. A. Sodium morrhuate in the treatment of epi- condylitis of the humerus; a report of 5 cases. N. England J M., 1940, 222: 1071-4.—Tavenier, L. A propos du traitement de l'dpicondyhte des joueurs de tennis. Presse mdd., 1936, 44: 99.—Thomsen, W. Ueber den Tennisarm (Epicondylitis humeri) usw. Miinch. med. Wschr., 1935, 82: 1804-7.—West E. F. Tennis elbow. Med. J. Australia, 1938, 1: 330. ---- Epiphysis. Aitken, A. P. End results of fractures of the proximal humeral epiphysis. J. Bone Surg., 1936, 18: 1036-41.—Baraldi. A. A proposito de las fracturas de la epffisis superior del humero. Sem. mdd., B. Air., 1935, 42: 64.—Bruno, G. Ueber senile Strukturveranderungen der proximalen Humerusepiphyse. Fortsch. Rontgenstrahl., 1934, 50:287-9.—Chiari, O. Epiphy- seolyse im distalen Humerusende als Geburtsverletzung. Arch. Kinderh., 1936, 108: 213-7.—Clark, A. Case of congenital epiphyseal injury of upper extremity of humerus. N. Zealand M. J., 1911-12, 10: 23, 2 pl.—Cobellis, L. Su due casi di distaceo dell'epifisi inferiore deU'omero. Rinasc. med., 1928, 5: 1445.—Divis, G. Epiphyseolysis humeri unter betracht- licher Dislokation des Gelenkskopfes; unblutige Reposition. Arch, orthop. UnfaUchir., 1927, 25: 342-4.—El ward, J. F. Epiphysitis of the capitellum of the humerus. J. Am. M. Ass., 1939, 112: 705-8.—Fontan Maquieira, G. Diagn6stico radio- gr&fico de las epifisiolisis del humero. Arch, med., Madr., 1935, 38: 767-9.—Fourcher, K. R. Separation of lower humeral epiphysis. Med. Bull. (Standard Oil Co.) N. Y., 1935-36, 2: 262-6.—Gioia, T. A proposito de las fracturas de la epffisis superior del humero. Sem. mdd., B. Air., 1934, 41: pt 2, 1132- 7.—Guilleminet & Truchet. Sur 3 cas de ddcollement dpiphy- saire parfait du condyle externe de l'humdrus chez l'enfant. Lyon mdd., 1936, 158: 11-4.—Jorge, M. Traitement des dpiphysiolyses obstdtricales de l'humdrus. Rev. orthop., Par., 1927, 14: 193-8.—Lluesma-Uranga, E. A prop6sito de la luxaci6n con fractura de la epffisis proximal del hiimero. Prensa mdd. argent., 1941, 28: 183-8.—Michel, L. Le ddcolle- ment obstdtrical de l'dpiphyse supdrieure de l'humdrus. Rev. orthop., Par., 1937, 24: 201-22.—Poli, A. Sul distaceo condro- epifisario da trauma ostetrico dell'estremo prossimale deU'omero. Arch, ortop., Milano, 1934, 50: 189-227.—Roche, A. E. The ultimate result of a case of separated upper epiphysis of the humerus. Clin. J., Lond., 1926, 55: 478, pl.—Roth, P. B. Softening of the upper humeral epiphyses; ?typhoid arthritis. Proc. R. Soc. M., Lond., 1928-29, 22: Sect. Orthop., 63. ------ Permanent separation of the epiphysis from the capitellum. Lancet, Lond., 1931, 1: 1346-7.—SaxI, A. Wie erkennt man und behandelt man die Epiphyseolysis des Humeruskopfes intra partum? Wien. klin. Wschr., 1927, 40: 1339.—Silvestrini, L. Sul trattamento cruento deU'epifisi superiore deU'omero. Gazz. internaz. med. chir., 1930, 38: 37-46.—Skrygin, V. P. [Epi- physiolysis of the head of the humerus] Ortop. travmat., 1936, 10: 117-42.—Solimano, O. J. Desprendimiento epifisiario de la epffisis humeral superior. Sem. mdd., B. Air., 1927, 34: 597-614.—Tavernier. Sdquelle d'un ddcollement dpiphysaire obstdtrical de l'extrdmitd supdrieure de l'humdrus. Lyon chir., 1935, 32: 465.—Tejerina Fotheringham, W. De las fracturas de la epffisis superior del humero. Sem. mdd., B. Air., 1934, 41: pt 2, 981-3.—Zanolli, R. Fratture dell'epifisi superiore deU'omero. Chir. org. movim., 1928, 12: 445-51. ---- Examination. Lexer, E. W. *Untersuchung iiber die Kno- chenharte des Humerus [Freiburg i. B.] p.227- 43. 8? Berl., 1928. Also Zschr. ges. Anat. 2. Abt., 1928-29, 14: Friedel. A. Die Gestalt des Oberarmbeines; ein neues Messverfahren fiir die gegenseitigen Beziehungen von Stellung und Form der Gelenkenden zum Schaft und zum Nachbar- knochen. Zschr. ges. Anat., 1. Abt., 1929, 90:1-45.—Mechanik, HUMERUS 888 HUMERUS N. Untersuchung der Markhohle und der kompakten Pchicht des Oberarmbeines des Menschen und der Haustiere. Ibid., 1929, 89: 513-31. ---- Foramina. Rehberg, W. *Das Foramen supratrochlear humeri und sein Vorkommen als Nebenbefund im Rontgenmatcrial der chirurgischen Universitats- Klinik Konigsberg von 1927-35. 15p. 21cm. Konigsb., 1936. Hirsh, I. S. The supratrochlear foramen: clinical and anthro- pological considerations. Am. J. Surg., 1927, 2: 500-5. ------ On a foramen in the lower extremity of the humerus. Radiology, 1928, 10: 199-20S.—Themido, A. A. Un nouveau ddtail morphologique de l'humdrus: le trou marginal ou perforation osseuse sus-dpitrochldenne. Fol. anat. Univ. conimbr., 1926, 1: No. 14, 1-3, pl. ---- Forensic aspect. Schranz, D. [Practical value of examining the humeral bone] Orv. hetil., 1933, 77: 292-4. Also Deut. Zschr. gerichtl. Med., 1933, 22: 332-61. ---- Fracture. See also Arm; Elbow; Shoulder, etc. Bendixen, P. A. Fractures of the humerus. Surg. J., 1924- 25, 31: 236-9.—Cohn. 1. Fractures of the humerus. Dallas M. J., 1930, 16: 11-6.—Colp, R., & Findlay, R. T. Fractures of the humerus. Surg. Clin. N. America, 1928, 8: 461-7.— Dehne, E. Grundsatzliches uber die Briiche des Oberarmkopfes. Arch, orthop. UnfaUchir.. 1938-39, 39: 434-64.—Griswold, R. A., Goldberg, H.. & Joplin, R. Fractures of the humerus. Am. J. Surg., 1939, 43: 31-8.—Jeanmarie. Oberarmbruche. Ther. Gegenwart, 1938, 79: 237.—Kirby, D. Fractures of the humerus. Surg. J., 1926-27, 33: 62-5.—McKenna, H. Frac- ture of left humerus. Surg. Clin. N. America, 1935, 15: 593.— Meyerding, H. W. Fracture of the humerus. Minnesota M., 1931, 14: 963-70.—Miller. E. M. Fractures of the upper arm. In Textb. Surg. (Christopher, F.) 3. ed., Phila., 1942, 629-36 — Penn, J. Fractures of the humerus. J. Tennessee M. Ass., 1934, 27: 344-56.—Schrader. Oberarmbruch (eine Selbst- beobachtung) Munch; med. Wschr., 1934, 81: 972-4 — Weinstein, M. Fractures of the humerus; a study of 53 cases. Am. J. Surg., 1926, 1: 80-6. Also repr. ---- Fracture, comminuted. Felsenreich, F. Zur operativen Behandlung der Triimmer- briiche des distalen Humerusendes. Zbl. Chir., 1934, 61: 1713-20.—Landivar, A. F., & Leoni Iparraguirre, C. A. Sobre un caso de fractura supra-condilo inter-condilea conminuta del humero, tratada por el mdtodo de L. Zeno modificado. Bol. Soc. cir. B. Aires, 1935, 19: 1057-66.—Nagel, L. C. A method of traction for severely comminuted fractures of the lower end of the humerus. J. Am. Osteopath. Ass., 1940-41, 40: 313.—Piccioli, P. Protezione muscolare del nervo radiale di destra in un caso di frattura comminuta chiusa deU'omero fra terzo medio e terzo inferiore. Arch. ital. chir., 1932, 31: 609.— Vascoboinic. H. [Considerations on the surgical treatment of comminuted fractures of the humerus] Rev. san. rml., Bucur. 1934, 33: 542-7. ---- Fracture: Complication. See also Radial nerve, Paralysis, etc. Cauvy-Saint-Patjl, Y. M. A. A. *Contribu- tion a l'etude des complications nerveuses des fractures de l'extremite inferieure de l'humerus chez l'enfant. 85p. 8? Par., 1937. Rappoport, L. *Des fractures de l'humdrus dans la paralysie infantile. 16p. 8? Par., 1924. Auge\ Un cas de paralysie radiale k la suite d'une fracture de l'humdrus; traitement par liberation du nerf. Arch. Soc sc. mdd. biol. MontpelUer, 1932, 13: 307-9.—Benso, F. Con- tributo al trattamento della paralisi del nervo radiale nelle fratture deU'omero. Minerva med., Tor., 1931, 22: pt 2, 723-7.—Biebl, R. Ueber einen Fall von veralteter Luxations- fraktur des Oberarmes mit Verrenkung des Kopfes nach hinten. Arch, orthop. UnfaUchir., 1936, 37: 52-4.—Blanc, H. Fracture du col anatomique de l'humdrus avec luxation de la tdte en dedans et compression du paquet vasculo-nerveux; operation (extirpation de la tdte) rdsultat satisfaisant. BuU. Soc chir. Paris, 1928, 20: 350-9.—Christide, E. Traitement de la luxation-fracture de l'humdrus. Rev. ehir., Bucur., 1938, 41: 699.—Clavelin, C. Au sujet des parables radiales dans les fractures de la diaphyse humdrale. BuU. mdd.. Par., 1935, 49: 619-21.—Courty. L. Paralysie radiale datant de 3 mois consdeutive k un enclavement du nerf au niveau d'une fracture de lhumdrus par balle; libdration; rdapparition immddiate de la motricitd. J. bc. mdd. LiUe, 1922, 40: 86-9.—Cubides Pardo, E. Complicaci6n nerviosa en un caso de fractura del humero. Report, med. cir., Bogota, 1929, 20: 98-100.—Darrach, W. Compound fracture of humerus; division of radial nerve. Ann. Surg., 1931, 93: 1264.—D6novan. R. E.. & Cibils Aenirre, A. La parrilisis del nervio radial en las fracturas del hi'imero. Bol. Soc. cir. B. Aires, 1935, 19: 1209-18.—Dujarler, C. Fracture de l'humdrus avec paralysie radiale immddiate: intervention, ddgagement du nerf coined entre les fragments; ostdosynthdse; gudrison. Bull. Soc. nat. chir., Par., 1926, 52: 713.—Esnaurrizar, M. L. Un caso de fractura del humero con ruptura de la arteria humeral. Rev. As. mdd. mex.. 1920, 5: 1458-00.-—Ghormley, It. K. CompUcations of fractures of the humerus. Surg. Clin. X. America, 1935, 15: 1223-5—Gil- creest, E. L. The treatment of complicated fractures of the humerus involving the shoulder joint. West. J. Surg., 1932, 40: 124—33. Also repr.—Guermonprez, F. Sur une complica- tion inddite de la fracture par torsion de l'humdrus. J. sc. mdd. Lille, 1926, 44: 169-78.—Hartemann & Vial. Paralysie radiale compliquant une fracture de l'humdrus chez le nouveau- nd. Nourrisson, 1936, 24: 29").— I.andivar, A. F. A prop6sito de un caso de fractura del humero con par&Usis radial. Bol. Soc. cir. B. Aires, 1933, 17: 622-5.—Lindvall, S. [Case of ostitis fibrosa of the humerus with fracture] Sven. lak. tidn., 1935, 32: 1030.—McMahan, A. R. Fractured humerus with unusual complications; case report. Memphis M. J., 1936, 11: No. 5, 14-6.—Marque. A. M. Evoluci6n de la neuritis trau- matica del radial en las fracturas del humero. Rev. espec., B. Air., 1929, 4: 197-208.—Martin du Pan, C. Infraction ischdmique de Volkmann gudrie par artdriectomie de l'lmmerale. Rev. mdd. Suisse rom., 1939, 59: 877-82.—Meyer-Wildisen, R. Zur Luxationsfraktur am Humeruskopf. Schweiz. med. Wsehr., 1935, 65: 722.—Newell, E. T. Fractures of the humerus, compUcated by injury of the musculo-spiral nerve; report of 3 cases treated without operation. Indust. M., 1938, 7: 747 9.-- Peixoto, G. Fratura de humeros com paralisia do nervo radial. Rev. med. mil., Rio, 1934, 23: 259-66.—Richard, A. Paralysie du nerf radial inclus dans un cal de fracture obstetrirale de l'humdrus droit; intervention; gudrison. Bull. Soe. nat. ehir., Par., 1928, 54: 994.—Rocher. Le syndrome de Volkmann dans les fractures obstdtricales de l'humdrus. Bordeaux chir., 1931, 2: 368.—Roederer, C. Fracture de l'humdrus et luxation de 1'dpaule. Bull. Soc. chir. Paris, 1928, 20: 544-6—Sachs, E. Ueber Radialisliihmung bei Humerusfraktur. Med. Klin., Berl., 1932, 28: 1600.—Schwartz, A. Les fractures de l'humdrus avec paralysie radiale immddiate. Bull. Soc. nat. chir., Par., 1926, 52: 533; 674.—Topa, P. Fracture de l'humdrus droit avec enclavement du nerf radial; cerclage avec des fils de sdtoline; gudrison. Rev. chir., Bucur., 1938, 41: 684.—Villette. J. La paralysie radiale dans les fractures de l'humdrug; les cas ou l'intervention chirurgicale s'impose. J. sc mdd. LiUe, 1928, 46: 53-9. ---- Fracture; Diagnosis. Wahl, F. A. TiiuschungsmogUchkeit bei der rontgenolo- gischen Diagnose der Humerusfraktur des Neugeborenen. Zbl. Gyn., 1936, 60: 2061-C. ---- Fracture: Etiology. See also Birth injury. Kimbron, E. *Ueber die typische Humerus- fraktur durch Propellerschlag. 31p. 8? Halle, 1919. Border, L. Der Bruch des Oberarmkopfchens (Fractura capituli humeri) und der Bruch der Oberarmrolle mit dem Kopfchen (Fractura trochleae et capituli humeri), typische anatomischkonstitutionell bedingte Verletzungen. Arch. orthop. UnfaUchir., 1930, 28: 734-42.—Gangolphe. Fracture obstdtricale de l'humdrus; paralysie radiale; libdration du nerf trente-huitidme jour; gudrison. Gaz. hop., Toulouse, 1898, 12: 58.—Giscaro. Fracture esquilleuse de l'humdrus produite par effort musculaire. J. mdd. Toulouse, 1855, 2. ser., 5: 326-30.—Semple, J. E. Bilateral fracture of the humerus due to electric shock. Brit. J. Surg., 1937, 25: 227-9 — Wilmoth, C. L. Recurrent fracture of the humerus due to sudden extreme muscular action. J. Bone Surg., 1930, 12: 168. ---- Fracture: Forensic aspect. Johner, T. Unfallmedizinische Studie fiber die Frakturen am obern Humerusende. Schweiz. med. Wschr., 1931, 61: 267-77.—Malpractice; ischemic paralysis foUowing fracture of humerus. J. Am. M. Ass., 1936, 106: 877. ---- Fracture, intra-articular. See also Elbow joint, Fracture; Shoulder. Christensen, O., & Hoist, J. E. [Intraarticular fractures of humerus at elbow-joint in children] Hospitalstidende, 1929, 72: 561; 577.—Costesco, P. Quelques cas de fractures intra- articulaires de l'extrdmitd supdrieure de l'humdrus et de la diaphyse, traitds orthopddiquement avec un appareil personnel. Rev. chir., Bucur., 1938, 41: 713.—Gilcreest, E. L. The treatment of compUcated fractures of the humerus involving the shoulder joint. Tr. West. Surg. Ass. (1931) 1932, 41: 133-47.—Prikhodko, A. K. [Methods in the treatment of comminuted intra-articular fractures of the inferior extremity of the humerus] Ortop. travmat., 1935, 9: 201-6.—Ramlau- Hansen, O. [Intraarticular fracture of humerus at elbow-joint in children] Hospitalstidende, 1929, 72: 530; 649, HUMERUS 889 HUMERUS ---- Fracture, lower end. Avellan, W. *Ueber Frakturen des unteren Humerusendes bei Kindern. 187p. 8? Helsin., 1933. Autefage, M. Fracture de l'extrdmitd infdrieure de l'humd- rus; vissage osseux; bon rdsultat. Bull. Soc. nat. chir., Par., 1928, 54: 1172-5.—Bates, W. Fractures of lower end of humerus. Ann. Surg., 1934, 99: 1007.—Bosch Aviles, L. Tratamiento de las fracturas de la extremidad inferior del humero. An. Hosp. Cruz, Barcel., 1930, 4: 197-203.—Cairo, G. Le fratture deU'estremiti inferiore deU'omero. Policlinico, 1925, 32: sez. chir., 479-93.—Campbell, O. J. The treatment of fractures of the lower end of the humerus. Minnesota M., 1935, 18: 192-5.—Chaton, M. A propos des fractures par flexion de l'extrdmitd inferieure de l'humdrus. J. chir., Par., 1936, 55: 549-51.—Christidi, E. Fracture de la diaphyse humdrale droite, dans le tiers infdrieur; consohdation vicieuse; paralysie du nerf radial par inclavation et dcrasement entre les fragments; greffage avec moelle dpinidre de lapin. Rev. chir Bucur., 1940, 43: 811-6.—Cole, W. H. Fractures of the lower end of the humerus. Minnesota M., 1929, 22: 523-6.— Colucci, C. Contributo cUnico alia cura cruenta delle fratture dell'estremo inferiore omerale nella pratica infantile. PoU- clinico, 1926, 32: sez. chir., 315-21.—David, L. Etude clinique et thdrapeutique des fractures fermdes de l'extrdmitd infdrieure de l'humdrus. Gaz. hop., 1932, 105: 720; 767.—Eastwood, W. J. The T-shaped fracture of the lower end of the humerus J. Bone Surg., 1937, 19: 364-9.—Eerland, L. D. [Injuries of the tendons in fractures of the lower end of the humerus] Ned. tschr. geneesk., 1939, 83: 3574-82, 3 pl.—Eliason, E. L., & McLaughlin, C. W., jr. Fractures of the lower end of the humerus. Aril. J. Surg., 1934, 23: 79-88. Also repr.—Felsen- reich, F. Ueber Frakturen des unteren Humerusendes bei Kindern. Wien. med. Wschr., 1935, 85: 1235.—Garceau, G. J. Fractures of the lower end of the humerus. J. Am. M. Ass 1939, 112: 623-6.—Gaul, J. S. Fractures of the humerus; with especial reference to treatment of fractures about the elbow. South. M. & J., 1926, 88: 584-6.—Gioia, T. A prop6sito del tratamiento operatorio en las fracturas en Y de la extremidad inferior del humero. Bol. Soc. cir. B. Aires, 1930, 14: 575-9.— Hergouignan, L., & Gaudichon, A. Le traitement des paraly- sies radiales consdeutives aux fractures de 1'extrdmitd infdrieure de l'humdrus. Progr. mdd., Par., 1933, 629.—Hitzrot, J. M. Fractures at the lower end of the humerus in adults. Surg. CUn. N. America, 1932, 12: 291-304.—Hoshall, F. A. Treat- ment of fractures of the lower third of the humerus. South. M. J., 1941, 34: 1152-4.—Lang, C. Die Behandlungsmethodik und die Heilergebnisse der Briiche des unteren Humerusendes an der Chirurgischen Universitatsklinik zu Konigsberg i. Pr. wahrend der letzten 7Yi Jahre. Arch, orthop. UnfaUchir., 1934-35, 35: 129-46.—Lapeyrie. Une fracture exceptionnelle de 1'extrdmitd infdrieure de l'humdrus; ddcalottement condylo- trochlden. Arch. Soc. sc mdd. biol. Montpellier, 1939, 20: 303-7.—Madsen, E. [On the rotation of the upper-arm with special reference to fractures of the lower portion of the humerus] Ugeskr. laeger, 1939, 101: 567-73.—Masmonteil, F. Ostdo- synthdse des fractures de l'extrdmitd infdrieure de l'humdrus. In Pract. chir. illustrde (Pauchet, V.) 3. dd., Par., 1932, 18: 149-61.—Nandrot. Fracture de l'extrdmitd infdrieure de l'humdrus chez un enfant de 7 ans, ayant ddtermind une paralysie compldte des nerfs mddian, cubital et radial et une oblitdration de l'artdre humdrale. BuU. Soc. nat. chir., Par., 1935, 61: 1105; 1144.—Olivares, L. Tratamiento de las fracturas de la extremidad inferior del humero en los nifios. An. Acad. nac. med., Madr. (1935) 1936, 55: 480-92.—Pauw, F. [Treatment and prognosis of fractures of the distal end of the humerus] Ned. tschr. geneesk., 1940, 84: 1374-6.—Piotet, G. Les fractures de l'extrdmitd infdrieure de l'humdrus. Rev. mdd. Suisse rom., 1938, 58: 321-47.—Scougall, S. H. Frac- tures of the lower end of the humerus and their compUcations.. Med. J. AustraUa, 1936, 2: 873-81.—Shands, A. R., jr. Mal- united fractures of lower end of humerus. Am. J. Surg., 1937, 36: 679-93.—Sorrel, E., & Sorrel-Dejerine. De la frdquence relative et de l'intdrdt pratique des paralysies nerveuses dans les fractures fermdes rdcentes de l'extrdmitd infdrieure de l'humdrus. J. mdd. chir., Par., 1938, 109: 337-48. Also Rev. orthop., Par., 1938, 3. sdr., 25: 609-47.—Yachnin, S. C. Frac- tures of the lower end of the humerus. J. M. Soc. N. Jersey, 1939. 36: 197-201. ---- Fracture: Military aspect. Baudet, G. Deux cas de fracture de l'humdrus par contrac- tion musculaire chez les lanceurs de grenades. Bull. Soc. nat. chir., Par., 1933, 59: 536-9.—Bressot, E. Huit cas de fractures de l'humdrus chez des grenadiers. Ibid., 1928, 54: 339-41.— Casas Ochoa, T. Fracturas de guerra diafisarias de humero. Actas Congr. mdd. mil. (Spain) 1939, 1. Congr., 64-84 — Ciszkiewicz, H. [Fractures of the humerus among the hand granade throwers] Lek. wojsk., 1936, 27: 289-98.—Coureaud & Dalger. Fracture de la diaphyse humdrale chez les lanceurs de grenades. Arch. mdd. pharm. nav., 1926, 116: 338-43.— Kehl. Ueber die Torsionsfraktur des Humerus bei Hand- granatenwurf. Deut. Militararzt, 1938, 3: 249-51.—Kinney, L. C, & Elliott, A. E. Explosive fractures of the upper end of the humerus. Radiology, 1927, 8: 245-7.—Matsui. S. H. Frakturen des Humerus beim Handgranatenwurf. Gun idan bi, 1934, No. 248, 4.—Parvulescu, Gh., & Vascoboinic, H. [Grenadiers fracture; fracture of the humerus due to the contracture of the muscles in throwing grenades] Rev. san mil., Bucur., 1934, 33: 316-22.—Perrignon de Troyes & Bourguet. du. Fracture ouverte de l'humdrus par balle de fusil: section du nerf radial. Bull. Soc. mdd. mil. fr., 1937 31- 602-5.—Rigaud. Fracture de la diaphyse humdrale chez un lanceur de grenade. Ibid., 1939, 33: 238-41.—Rosas, P Un caso de fractura expuesta y conminuta del tercio superior (lei humero por proyectil de arma de fuego. Rev. cir Hosn Judrez, Mdx., 19371 8: 237-42— Roux, G., & Guibal, A. A propos des fractures de l'humdrus dites fractures des lanceurs Arch. Soc. sc. mdd. biol. MontpelUer, 1928, 9: 255-7.—Smo- lianitsky, Z. [Fractures of the humerus in granade throwersl Voen. san. delo, 1935, 47-50. ---- Fracture, neck. Bork, H. *Ueber die Behandlung der Fraktur am chirurgischen Hals des Oberarmes nach den Erfahrungen der Chirurgischen Klinik Konigsberg in den letzten sieben Jahren. 25p. 8? Konigsb., 1935. ' Anderson, H. M. Reduction of fractures of the surgical neck of the humerus. Brit. M. J., 1934, 1: 232.—Arnesen, A. J. A. [Case of fractura colli humeri et tub. majoris with luxatio capitis; repositio capitis et fixatio tub. maioris] Norsk mag. laegevid., 1938, 99: 924-7.—Austin, L. J. Frac- tures of the morphological neck of the humerus in children. Canad. M. Ass. J., 1939, 40: 546.—Balice, G. Contributo alia cura delle fratture recenti ed antiche del collo chirurgico deU'omero. Chir. org. movim., 1925-26, 10: 25-48.—Barcaroli, I. Sul trattamento cruento deUe fratture cervicali deU'omero. PoUclinico, 1932, 39: sez. chir., 1-19.—Bosch Aviles, L. Una modification en mi aparato para el tratamiento de las fracturas del cuello del humero con desplazamientos de fragmentos. An. Hosp. S. Cruz, Barcel., 1929, 3: 177-9.—Brekke, A. [Reduction of fracture of the neck of the humerus; Dr Paul Treider in memoriam] Norsk mag. laegevid., 1938, 99: 928- 31.—Caldwell, J. A., & Smith, J. Treatment of unimpacted fractures of the surgical neck of the humerus. Am. J. Surg., 1936, 31: 141-4.—Caritat, R. J. Fracturas del cuello quirlirgico del humero irreductibles por maniobras incruentas en el nifio. Arch. urug. med., 1938, 13: 356-66.—Charry, V. Un cas de fracture irrdductible du col chirurgical de l'humdrus chez un adolescent. Rev. orthop., Par., 1937, 24: 244-7.—Chevereau. Une observation de fracture du col chirurgical de l'humdrus, avec luxation de la tete humdrale, rdduite chirurgicalement. Bull. Soc. chir. Paris, 1934, 26: 37-46.—Conwell, H. E. Frac- tures of the surgical neck and epiphyseal separations of upper end of humerus. J. Bone Surg., 1926, 8: 508-16.—Cotton, F. J., & Morrison, G. M. Leverage reduction in fractures of the urgical neck of the humerus. N. England J. M., 1934, 211: 924.—Duchet-Suchaux. Fracture du col humdral; ostdo- synthdse. Bull. Soc. chir. Paris, 1937, 29: 131-3.—Fenkner. Einrichtung von Oberarmbriichen in der Nahe des Collum anatomicum. Arch. klin. Chir., 1930-31, 163: 740-4.— Finley, C. A. Fracture of the neck of the humerus. Illinois M. J., 1926, 49: 83.—Frankau, G. A manipulative method for the reduction of fractures of the surgical neck of the hu- merus. Lancet, Lond., 1933, 2: 755.—Franke. C. Zur Be- handlung der Oberarmfrakturen am Collum chirurgicum mit einigen Bemerkungen zur Nachbehandlung von Frakturen. Chirurg, 1931, 3: 647-50.—Geckeler, E. O. Treatment of fractures in the neck of the humerus without immobilization. Surgery, 1941, 10: 917-26.—Gianturco, G. Contributo al trattamento cruento ed incruento delle fratture del collo chirugico deU'omero. Chir. org. movim., 1929, 13: 447-67.— Gioia, T. Fractura del cueUo quirtirgico del omdplato asociada a la fractura de la di&fisis humeral. Prensa mdd. argent., 1928, 15: 509-13.—Giorgi, C. Un caso di frattura del coUo chirurgico dell' omero guarito mediante trazione diretta sullo scheletro appUcata attraverso vite. Gior. venet. sc. med., 1939, 13: 414-8.—Grashey. Kindliche Fractura colU humeri. Ront- genpraxis, 1936, 8: 396.—Gregersen, N. F. [Treatment of fracture of the neck of the humerus] Hospitalstidende, 1933, 76: 769-76.—Guillermo & Hokayem. Fracture du col anato- mique et transtubdrositaire de lhumdrus gauche avec luxation postdro-infdrieure irrdductible; rdsection prdcoce; suites opdratoires et rdsultats fonctionnels un an aprds. Bull. Soc. mdd. mil. fr., 1939, 33: 272-5.—Jackson, A. C. Treatment of fractures of the surgical neck and shaft of the humerus. J. M. Ass. Alabama, 1937-38, 7: 253-5.—Jensen, J. The treatment of fractures of the neck of the humerus. Acta chir. scand., 1931-32, 69: 498. Also Hygiea, Stockh., 1932, 94: 403.—Judet, H. Fracture du col anatomique de l'humdrus avec luxation de la tete. Bull. Soc. chir. Paris, 1928, 20: 394_g—Karliol, G. Zur Behandlung der Oberarm-Hals- fraktur. Zbl. Chir., 1933, 60: 1818-21.—Krabbel, M. Zur Behandlung der dislozierten Oberarmhalsfrakturen. Ibid., 1934, 61: 1098-101.—Landivar, A. F. El enclavijamiento oseo en la's fracturas del cueUo quirtirgico del humero; sus resultados alejados. Actas congr. nac. cir., B. Air., 1930, 2. congr., 2: 826-49 ------ Fractura inter-delto pectoral de Baraldi- Bol. Soc cir. B. Aires, 1933, 17: 1064-76.—La Ragione, A. Lussazione ascellare della testa deU'omero con frattura come minuta del collo anatomico. Clin, chir., Milano, 1938, 41: 559-65.—Latkowski, M. [Treatment of fractures of the surgical neck of the humerus] Lek. wojsk., 1930, 15: 97-106, HUMERUS 890 HUMERI'S 4 pl.—bee, H. G. Fracture of the surgical neck of the humerus with dislocation of the humeral head, successfully treated by a closed method. N. England J. M., 1928, 199: 175. L'Heu- reux, M. Fracture du col anatomique de l'humdrus avec luxation thoracique de la tdte; extirpation par voie transpecto- rale. Bull. Soe. nat. chir., Par., 53: I25S-63.—Loyer. Frac- ture du col anatomique et de la grosse uibdrositd de l'humdrus traitee par la resection. Arch. mdd. pharm. nav., 1937, 12?: 293-7.—Mecray, P. M. Fracture of the surgical neck of the humerus with subcoracoid dislocation of the head. Surg. Clin. N. America, 1926, 6: 1619-21.—Moorhead, J. J. Con- servative treatment in fractures of the neck of the humerus. (Connecticut M. J., 1941, 5: 207-9.—Napalkow, N. Disloka- tion des Gelenkkopfs beim Bruch des Schulterbeins im chirur- si-elien Hals. Arch, orthop. UnfaUchir., 1931, 30: 156-62.— Peraire, M. Fracture du col de l'humdrus avec luxation de la tete humerale. Bull. Soc. chir. Paris, 1928, 20: 398-400.— Pesek, G. Neue Aufnahmerichtung bei Briichen im Bereiche des Oberarmhalses. Rontgenpraxis, 1933, 5: 827.—Piet, P. Le traitement des fractures du col de l'humdrus. J. sc. med. Lille, 1925, 43: pt 2, 53-7.—Reznikov, L. B. [Fractures of the anatomical neck of the humerus] Ortop. travmat., 1938, 12: No. 6, 57-04.—Rocher, H. L. Fracture du col chirurgical de l'humdrus; vissage; rdsultat dloignd. Bordeaux chir., 1931, 2: 381.—Sarroste. Fracture pertuberculaire du col chirurgical de 1 humerus gauche avec luxation postdrieur irrdductible. Mdm. Acad, chir., Par., 1937, 63: 402-5.—Savage, F. J. Fracture of the surgical neck of the humerus. J. Lancet, 1935, 55: 635-7.— Sbrozzi, M. Due casi di frattura del collo deU'omero con lussa- zione alia teste. Riv. osp., 1925, 15: 317-20.—Snodgrass, L. E. Bilateral fracture of the anatomical neck of the humerus; case report. Am. J. Roentg., 1936, 36: 310. ---- Fracture, open. Hidden, F. L'ostdosynthdse primitive dans les fractures ouvertes de l'humerus. J. sc. mdd. Lille, 1920, 38: 175-8.— Miranda Matus, C. Fractura expuesta del humero. Rev. mex. cir., 1939, 7: 207-70.—Nasta, T., & Popesco-Urlueni, M. Fracture ouverte intra-articulaire de l'extrdmitd infdrieure de l'humdrus droit. Rev. chir., Bucur., 1938. 41: 109-12.— Nunziata, A., & Marino. H. Fracturas expuestas de la dirifisis humeral. Sem. mdd., B. Air., 1937, 44: pt 2, 1445-7. ---- Fracture: Pathology. Baraldi, A. Fractura inter-deho-pectoial. Dfa B. Air., 1934-35, 7: 50-3.- Gilson Marhado. Sobre casos de destacamento do troquiter. Pev. mdd. Pernai 1939. 9: 251-61.—Grashey. Seltener Abhmeh des cubitalis humeri. Rontgenpraxis, 1937. 9: 270. -Pforringer. Ein Fall von ungewbhnlicher Knochenneubildung nach Schuss- bruch. Fortsch. Rontgenstrahl., 1920-27, 35: 1234 (i. Proc. Fracture, shaft. Lefrancois-Bailliard, P. *A propos d'un mode de traitement des fractures fermdes de la diaphyse humdrale. 36p. 8? Par., 1938. Lowers, G. *Ergebnisse operativ behandelter Oberarmschaftfrakturen an der Leipziger Klinik [Leipzig] 23p. 23cm. [Zeulenroda i. Thur.j 1936. Alglave, P. Application de la voie transoldcranienne k une fracture transversale situde k la limite du tiers moyen et du tiers infdrieur de l'humdrus. Bull. Soc. nat. chir., Par., 1929, 55: 1028-32.—Blum, L. Double pulley traction in fractures of the shaft of the humerus; report of case. J. Am. M. Ass., 1933, 101: 1953. Also Surg. Gyn. Obst., 1937, 65: 812-20.— Caldwell, J. A. Treatment of fractures of the shaft of the humerus by hanging cast. Ibid.. 1940, 70: 421-5.—Dehne, E. Die Schaftbriiche des Oberarms; Bericht iiber Behandlung und Ergebnisse von 105 Fallen. Arch, orthop. UnfaUchir., 1938-39, 39: 405-76.—Dupuy de Frenelle. Ostdosynthdse par vissage des fractures du tiers superieur de la diaphyse humdrale. Rev techn. chir., Par., 1932, 24: 193-202. ------ Cerclage des fractures obliques de la moitid supdrieure de la diaphyse humdrale. Ibid., 1939, 31: 90-4.— Ehalt. W. Beitrag zur operativen Behandlung der Oberarmschaftbriiche. Chirurg 1936, 8: 102-0. Also Zbl. Chir., 1938, 65: 2584-7.—Eparvier & Notter. Fracture sous-pdriostde de la partie moyenne de l'humdrus gauohe; la radiographie immddiate n'ayant pas rdvdld le trait de fracture, celui-ci est visible seulement sur un deuxidme clichd pratiqud une semaine aprds. Bull. Soc gyn obst. Paris, 1938, 27: 771.—Eve, D., & Daniel, R. A., jr. The treatment of fractures of the shaft of the humerus. South M. J., 1941, 34: 311-5.—Fransen, J. W. P. [Fracture of the upper part of the shaft of the humerus] Ned. mschr. geneesk 1926, 13: 525-30, pl.—Gabrielle, H. Fracture fermde de l'humdrus k sa partie moyenne, section de l'artdre humdrale. paralysie des nerfs mddian, cubital et radial. Lyon chir., 1938^ 35: 608.—Kafka, A. [Apparatus for abduction and extension in treatment of diaphysal fractures of the humerus] Cas. ldk desk.. 1936, 75: 450-2.—Larget, M. Fractures de la diaphyse humdrale. Bull, mdd., Par., 1938, 52: No. 23, Suppl., 1-3 — Mabry, C. B. A simplified method of treating fractures of the shaft of the humerus. J. Florida M. Ass., 1937-38, 24: 436-9.— MrMurray, T. P. Fractures of tIn- shaft and subcapital region of the humerus. Brit. M. J., lM.;s. 2: 131-7. Also in Treatm Cen. Pract., 1940, 4: 22-32.- Pridie, K. H. Fractures of the shaft of the humerus. Proc. R. Soe. M., Lond., 1938-39, 32: Sect. Orthop., 649.—Rogers, H. End-result study of humeral shaft fractures. Surg. Gyn. Obst., 1934, 59: 934-42. Also in Experience Manngem. Fractures (Wilson, P. D.) Phila., 1938, 257-95- Rowley, G. D. A simple method of reducing mid-shaft fractures of the humerus. Brit. M. J., 1942, 1: 41.— Smyth, ('. M.f jr. Fractures of the shaft of the humerus. Ann Surg., 1934, 99: 1013-6.—Wagner, J. H. fractures of the shaft of the humerus. Surg. Gyn. Obst., 193H, 66: 482 -5. ---- Fracture, spontaneous and pathological. Hall, C. L. A fracture of the humerus, probably syphilitic in origin. 5p. 8? [n. pl ] 1920. Badolle, Chevalier & Dupont, A. Ostdite kystique de l'extrdmitd supdrieure de l'humdrus; fracture spontanee; exten- sion: rdsultats. Loire mdd., 1932, 46: 205-7, pl. Burrows, H. J. Pathological fracture of the humerus complicating late secondary syphilis. Brit. J. Surg., 1930, 24: -152 5. Gossler, R. [Pathological fracture of the humerus during a sport game] ('as. lek. desk., 1938, 77: 395 -7.— Gratz, G. M. Pathologic fracture of humerus. Surg. Clin. N. America, 1929, 10: 635- 40.—Hermeto, S., j r. Frfitura patologica do humero, em doente portador da molest ia de James Paget, tratada pelo aparelho de Sejournet. Ann. paul. med. cir., 1934, 27: 519-30.— Konjetzny, G. E. Fraktur bei umschriebener Ostitis deformans Paget des Humerus. Zschr. orthop. Chir., 1933, 60: 363-5.— Loubat & Grenet. Un cas d'ostdite kystique de l'humdrus, avec fractures k rdpetition. Bordeaux chir., 1932, 3: 496-9.— Pridie, K. H. Pathological fracture of the right humerus. Proc. R. Soc. M., Lond., 1937-38, 31: 1275, 2 pl.—Rivarola, R. A., & Bettinotti, S. L. Resultados del injerto 6seo en una frac- tura patologica por quiste simple del humero. Arch. lat. amer. pediat., B. Air., 1929, 3. ser., 23: 264-7.—Rocher, H. L.. & Pouyanne. Fracture spontande de la diaphyse humdrale gauche; premidre manifestation d'une maladie de Paget. Bordeaux chir., 1931, 2: 374. ■------Kyste de l'humdrus gauche chez un enfant de 15 ans; fractures pathologiques itdra- tives; trdpanation suivie de greffes; gudrison. Rev. chir., Bucur., 1938, 41: 461-6.—Tixier. Fracture pathologique de l'humdrus droit; cancer du rein gauche; ndphrectomie et ampu- tation du bras; gudrison. Lyon chir., 1933, 30: 707-9.— Wolfromm. Fracture de l'humdrus au niveau d'une zone d'os- tdite fibreuse. BuU. Soc. nat. chir., Par., 1929, 55: 423. ---- Fracture, supracondylar. Abdou Harb, A. Contribution a l'etude des fractures suscondyliennes transversales de l'hume- rus chez l'enfant et de leur traitement. 34p. 8? Geneve, 1920. Bosken, H. *Die Behandlung der ischa- mischen Kontraktur bei Jugendlichen nach supracondylar Fraktur des Oberarms und ihre Erfolge [Munster] 29p. 21cm. Meppen-Ems. 1933. Bottke, C. B. *Die Drahtcxtension im Dienste der Behandlung supracondylaerer Frak- turen [Berlin] 19p. 8? Charlottenb., 1929. Chomet, J. S. *Technique orthopedique et mecanisme de la reduction des fractures trans- versales suscondyliennes de l'humdrus chez l'enfant. 68p. 8? Par., 1936. Daxl, O. *Die suprakondylare Humerus- fraktur und ihre Therapie [Rostock] 28p. 8? Hamb., 1933. Engelbrecht [A. F.] R. *Die supracondylare Humerusfraktur bei Kindern, ihre Komplika- tionen und ihre Behandlung. 32p. 8? Berl.. 1937. Fischer, W. *Ueber die typische supra- kondylare Fraktura humeri [Munster] 22p. 8? Bottrop i. W., 1934. Kalin, H. *Bleibende Stellungsanomalien nach supracondylaren Humerusfrakturen [Zu- rich] 38p. 8? Lpz., 1922. Keller, E. *Ueber die suprakondylaren Humerusfrakturen bei Kindern und deren Be- handlungsarten unter besonderer Beriicksichti- gung der Muskelmechanik. p.702-28. 23cm. Heidelb., 1938. Also Arch. klin. Chir., 1938, 192: HUMERUS 891 HUMERUS Lenkeit, L. *Die supracondylar Humerus- fraktur bei Kindern und ihre Behandlungs- ergebnisse wahrend der letzten 11 Jahre an der chirurgischen Universitatsklinik Berlin [Berlin] 39p. 21^cm. Koln, 1937. Samotjris, A. *Die supracondylar Humerus- fraktur und ihr Einfluss auf das Epiphysenwachs- tum [Kiel] 15p. 8? Bethel b. Bielefeld, 1930. Adams, J. D. A report on 6 cases of supracondylar fractures of the elbow. N. England J. M., 1937, 216: 837-42.—Albanese, A. 11 trattamento curativo creila frattura degli scolari (sopra- condiloidea deU'omero) Cult. med. mod., Pal., 1931, 10: 57-65.—Aurousseau, L. Ddbut de syndrome de Volkmann consdcutif k une fracture supracondyUenne de l'humdrus; intervention immddiate; gudrison. Mdm. Acad, chir., Par., 1938, 64: 945-53.—Bado, J. L., Pedemonte, P. V. Trata- miento de las fracturas supracondileas del humero complicadas de paraUsis radial. Rev. ortop. traumat., B. Air., 1939-40, 9: 1-10.—Bailey, G. G., jr. Nerve injuries in supracondylar fractures of the humerus in children. N. England J. M., 1939, 221: 260-3.—Baumann, E. Beitrage zur Kenntnis der Frak- turen am EUbogengelenk unter besonderer Berucksichtigung der Spatfolgen; AUgemeines und Fractura supracondylica. Beitr. klin. Chir., 1929, 146: 1-50.—Beck, A. Die unblutige Einrenkung der suprakondylaren kindlichen Humerusfraktur. Munch, med. Wschr., 1929, 76: 2161-3. ------ Zur Behand- lung der supracondylaren kindlichen Humerus-frakturen. Zbl. Chir., 1933, 60: 2242-50.—Boeminghaus, H. Behandlung der Frakturen am Ellenbogen, insbesondere der Fractura supra- condyUca. Med. Welt, 1932, 6: 446-9.— Boppe, M., & Chomet, J. Traitement des fractures sus-condvliennes de l'humdrus chez l'enfant. J. chir., Par., 1934, 43: 505-14.—Brandberg, R. On the treatment of supracondylar fractures of the humerus by reduction followed by fixation in plaster-splint. Acta chir. scand., 1939, 82: 400-12.—Briicke, H. Die Behandlung der suprakondylaren Humerusfraktur, unter besonderer Beriick- sichtigung der Abduktionsschiene nach Gold. Deut. Zschr. Chir., 1932, 237: 429-40.—Carli. C. Trazione col filo nelle fratture sovracondiloidee di gomito del bambino. Chir. org. movim., 1933-34, 18: 311-6.—Chiodin, L. Tratamiento de las fracturas supracondileas del codo en los nifios. Rev. mdd. Rosario, 1931, 21: 591-624.—Coenen. Der Entstehungs- mechanismus des suprakondylaren Oberarmbruches. Munch. med. Wschr., 1933, 80: 1174-7.—Coker, G. N. Supra-condvloid fracture of elbow. J. M. Ass. Georgia, 1928, 17: 66-9 — Delrez, L. Le traitement des fiactures supra-condylaires et fractures du condyle externe chez l'enfant. Arch. fr. belg. chir., 1926, 29: 880-7.—Descarpentries & Samsoen. Fracture supra- condyUenne chez l'enfant. Echo mdd. nord, 1932, 36: 236-8.— Deuticke, P. Ueber suprakondylare Humerusfrakturen des Erwachsenen. Deut. Zschr. Chir., 1935, 245: 302-8.—Deutsch- lander, K. Zur Behandlung der suprakondyliiren Ueberstrek- kungsbruche des Oberarms. Chirurg, 1934, 6: 733-42.— Dieulafe, L. Le traitement chirurgical des fractures sus- condyliennes de l'humdrus. Rev. techn. chir., Par., 1932, 24: 203-7.—Dieulafd, R. Paralysie du nerf mddian apres fracture supracondyUenne de l'humdrus. Mdm. Acad, chir., Par., 1940, 66: 703-6.—Dittrich, K. von. Ueber die operative Verwendung des parostalen Callus bei veralteten suprakondylaren Humerus- bruchen. Arch, orthop. UnfaUchir., 1928, 26: 613-20 — Donovan, R. E., & Otano Etchevehere, A. A prop6sito del tratamiento de las fracturas supraintercondileas del humero. Sem. mdd., B. Air., 1936, 43: 1606-10.—Dunn, N. Supra- condylar fracture of the elbow. Brit. M. J., 1936, 2: 663-5 — Dusi, E. Le comphcazioni; nervose nei corso delle fratture sovracondiloidee del gomito dei bambini. Chir. org. movim., 1935-36, 21: 274-84.—Fagge, C. H. Supracondylar fracture of the humerus. Brit. M. J., 1936, 1: 604.—Felsenreich, F. Behandlungsergebnisse nach schweren suprakondylaren Ober- armbriichen der Kinder im gefensterten Thorax-Armgips. Chirurg, 1936, 8: 128-33. ------ Zur Behandlung der suprakondylaren Humerusfraktur. Ibid., 651. —;---- Kindliche suprakondylare Frakturen und posttraumatische Deformitaten des Ellbogengelenkes. Arch, orthop. UnfaUchir., 1930-31, 29: 555-78.—Finochietto, R., & Llambias, A. Frac- tura supracondflea del codo en los nifios; tratamiento y icsul- tados. Sem. mdd., B. Air., 1933, 40: pt 2, 1837-59.—Fontaine, R., & Branzen, P. Un nouveau cas d'enclavement nrdduetible de l'artdre humdrale dans un foyer de fracture suscondylienne de l'humdrus. Rev. chir., Par., 1937, 56: 145-9—Frassineti, P. Frattura sopracondiloidea deU'omero per estensione ridotta e contenuta in apparecchio gessato ad arto iperesteso; esiti. Policlinico, 1929, 36: sez. chir., 623-38.—Glenn, F. W. Vascu- lar injuries compUcating supracondylar fractures of the humerus in children, with a case report. Bull. Jackson Mem. Hosp., Miami, 1941, 3: 29-36.—Gold, E. Zur Frage der Behandlung der supracondylaren Oberarmbruehe im Kindesalter. Zbl. Chir., 1929, 56: 8-11.—Gray, A. L. The diagnosis and manage- ment of supra-condylar fractures of the humerus. South. M. J., 1927, 20: 292-6.—Guilleminet. Fracture supracondyUenne du coude chez l'enfant. Lyon chir., 1934, 31: 324-6.------ Fracture supracondyUenne successive des deux coudes, a intervalle de 3 ans Vi; comparaison des rdsultats du traitement orthopddique et du traitement sanglant. Ibid., 1938, 35: 686-8.—Hansen, U. [After-examination in supra-condylar fractures of the humerus in_children] Nord. med., 1939, 2: 166I1"£-~HenryVM- -°- Supracondylar fractures of the elbow ana tneir complications. Minnesota M., 1935 18- 597__ i'-i^j AsP?tt0 radiologico tardivo della frattura sopra- condiloidea, dell omero, non ridotta, nei bambini. Rinasc. med., 1927, 4: 278-80, pl.—Iversen, S. C. [Late examinations of supracondyloid fractures of humerus in childrenl Ugeskr lager. 1929, 91: 1041-5.-.Tewett, E. L. A new closed method of in™*1'1^ supracondylar fractures of the elbow. Am. J. Surg., 1939, 44: 572-6.—Judet. H. Rdduction exacte par la mdthode non sanglante des fractures sus-condvhennes transverses de 1 humerus chez l'enfant. Bull. Soc. chir. Paris, 1936, 28: 542- 6- ------ Rdduction exacte par la mdthode orthopddique des fractures sus-condyhennes transverses de l'humdrus chez l'en- fant. P. verb. Congr. fr. chir., 1936, 45: 886.—Klages, F. Die suprakondylare Humerusfraktur des Kindes. Deut med Wschr., 1932, 58: 810-3. ------ Erfahrungen bei der Be- handlung der suprakondylaren Oberarmfraktur. Arch kUn Chir., 1935, 183: 668-71. Also Chirurg, 1935, 7: 362-70 — Landivar, A. F. Resultado del tratamiento operatorio en un caso de fractura suprac6ndilo-inter-condilea del humero en un adulto. Bol. Soc. cir. B. Aires, 1930, 14: 520-9.—Lassen*. C. Fracture suprarcondylienne de l'humdrus avec paralysie radiale immddiate; rdsection du nerf dilacdrd et suture suivies de gudri- son rapide. Bull. Soc. nat. chir., Par., 1927, 53: 1003-7.— Leriche, R. Rdtraction isolde des fldchisseurs et des pronateurs apres fracture sus-condylienne de l'humdrus et rupture sdche de l'artere humdrale; artdriectomie; gudrison. Ibid., 1928r 54: 212-6.—Leveuf, J. Les ldsions provoqudes parses troubles de la circulation capillaire consecutifs k la contusion de l'artdre humdrale dans les fractures supra-condyliennes de l'humdrus (soi-disant syndrome de Volkmann) Mdm. Acad, chir Par 1937, 63: 1312-21. Also J. chir., Par., 1938, 51: 177-214. & Godard, H. La rdduction sanglante des fractures supracondylienncs de l'humdrus chez les enfants. Bull. 'Soc. nat. chir., Par., 1934, 60: 915-20. Also J. chir., Par., 1935, 45: 357-69.—Macnab, D. S. A method of reducing supracondvlar fractures of the humerus. Canad. M. Ass. J., 1934, 30: 293- 5.—Marx, V. O. [Typical injuries of the radial nerve in supra- condylar fractures of the humerus] Ortop. travmat., 1935, 9: 30-5.—Matti, H. Zur Behandlung der supracondylaren Hume- rusfraktur. Chirurg, 1937, 9: 41-50.—Minne, J. Rdsultats dloignds du traitement orthopddique et chirurgical des fractures sus-condyliennes transverses de l'enfant. Echo mdd. nord, 1934, 3. ser., 1: 129-59.—Morwood, J. B. Two cases of supra- condylar fracture of the humerus with absent radial pulse. Brit. M. J., 1939, 1: 163.—Neraal, P. O. Treatment of supra- condylar fractures. J. Lancet, 1934,54: 621.—O'Connor, D. S. The treatment of supracondylar fractures of the humerus. Bull. U. S. Navy Dep. Dir. Prev. M., 1933, 31: 285-8.—Ostergaard Christensen, L. [Method of bandaging of supracondylar fractures in children] Ugeskr. laeger, i935, 97: 1216.—Pater- son Toledo, R. Fractura supracondflea del humero. Rev. ortop. traumat., B. Air., 1932-33, 2: 208-14.—Paton, R. Y. A method of reducing supra-condylar fractures of the humerus. Lancet, Lond., 1930, 2: 1180.—Perez Lorid. J. Fractura supracondflea del humero consoUdada con desplazamiento; consideraciones sobre un caso clinico. Vida nueva, Hab'ana, 1938,41:1-5.—Perrin. Fracture supra-condylienne non rdduite chez une enfant de 6 ans; ankylose du coude et paralysie radiale; gudrison apres intervention sanglante. Lyon chir., 1927, 24: 739-41.—Persson, M. Zur Behandlungstechnik der supra- kondylaren Humerusfraktur. Chirurg, 1938, 10: 650x4.— Pogorelsky, M. A. [Ambulatory treatment of supracondylar fractures of the humerus! Ortop. travmat., 1936, 10: 17-30.—■ Potts, W. J. The treatment of supracondylar fracture of the humerus. Ann. Surg., 1929, 89: 607-11.—Regele. Zur" Be- handlung der supracondylaren Oberarmbriiche im Kindesalter. Arch, orthop. UnfaUchir., ' 1933, 33: 544-50.—Rendu, A. Fracture sus-condylienne du coude avec paralysie radiale secondaire compldte gudrie spontandment. Lyon mdd., 1926, 138: 360.—Riosalido, J. Pardlisis del cubital consecutivas a fracturas supra-condfleas. Arch, espan. pediat., 11: 641-51.— Ritchkin, J. The treatment of supracondylar fractures. S. Afr. M. J., 1938, 12: 792.—Rocher, H. L., & Guillermin. Frac- ture haute sus-condylo-inter-condylienne de l'humerus; ostdo- synthdse avec plaque en Y par arthrotomie transoldcranienne; bon rdsultat. J. mdd. Bordeaux, 1927, 57: 723.—RouX, J. Trois cas de fractures suscondyUennes irrdductibles du coude; voie transoldcranienne, ostdosynthdse temporaire par un clou. Rev. mdd. Suisse rom., 1926, 46: 261-76.—Ruth, V. A. Supra- condylar fractures of the humerus; a new method of treatment. J. Iowa M. Soc, 1935, 25: 337-40.—Saner, F. D. Supracondy- lar fracture of the humerus. Brit. M. J., 1936, 1: 554.—Satta, F. Sulle fratture sovracondiloidee deU'omero dei bambini. Chir. org, movim., 1927, 11: 331-4.—Schaudig, H. Die Ein- richtung der supracondylaren Extensionsfraktur des Humerus. Zbl. Chir., 1931, 58: 843-5.—Schroeder, K. Zur Behandlungs- technik der suprakondylaren Humerusfraktur. Mschr. Unfallh., 1941, 48: 52-5.—Scollo, G. La cura della frattura sopracon- diloidea del gomito nell'infanzia. PoUclinico, 1935, 42: sez. chir., 183-92.—Sgrosso, J. A. La tracci6n esqueldtica en el tratamiento de las fracturas supracondileas del humero eh la infancia; 68 observaciones. Rev. ortop. traumat., B. Air., 1935-36, 5: 381-96.—Siris, I. E. Supracondylar fracture of the humerus; an analvsis of 330 cases. Surg. Gyn. Obst., 1939, 68: 201-22.—Sorrel. E., & Sorrel-Dejerine. Les ldsions du nerf cubital dans les fractures fermdes sus-condyliennes rdcentes de l'humdrus. Mdm. Acad, chir., Par., 1938, 64: 461-9.—Thorger- sen, E. [Supracondyle fractures of the humerus in children] HUMERUS 892 HUMERUS Norsk, mag. laegevid., 1935, 96: 121-42, 4 pl. ------ [Results in I'.ohler-treatment of supracondvlar fracture of the humerus in children] Ibid., 1937, 98: Forh. kir. foren. Oslo] 18-40, 16 pl—Thornton, L. Supracondylar fractures of the humerus; a method of accurate reduction. J. M. Ass. Georgia, 1928, 17: 440—4.—Tyler, G. T., jr. Supracondylar fracture of humerus; late results of operation for malunion. Am. J. Surg., 1929, 7: 867-9.—Verbrugge, J. Rdsultats dloignds du traitement chi- rurgical des fractures sus-condyliennes rdcentes et aneiennes du coude chez l'enfant. P. verb. Congr. fr. chir., 1935, 44: 1179- 90.—Volkmann (The) svndrome in supracondvloid fractures of the humerus. J. Am. M. Ass., 1938, 110: 451.—Wiedhopf, O. Zur Behandlung der suprakondylaren Humerusfraktur der Kinder mit Drahtextension an der EUe. Chirurg, 1936, 8: 395-7.—Zarazaga, J., & De Anquin, C. E. Fractura supra- condflea del humero. Dfa mdd., B. Air., 1942, 14: 176.—Zeno, L. O. Reducci6n espontanea de las fracturas supracondileas mediante la tracci6n esqueldtica. Bol. Soc. cir. B. Aires, 1930, It: 448-56. ------ Fracturas supracondileas del humero; tratamiento tipificado. Rev. ortop. traumat., B. Air., 1933-34, 3: 452-62. ---- Fracture: Treatment. Barba Inclan, A. Fracturas de la extremidad superior e inferior del humero, en el adulto. Cir. ortop. traumat., Habana, 1938, 6: 84-97.—North, J. P. Fractures of the humerus with particular reference to restoration of shoulder function. Week. Roster, Phila., 1938-39, 34: 812-6. ------ Restoration of function after fractures of the humerus. Pennsylvania M. J., 1940-41, 44: 1277-80.—Rufer, A. [Treatment of fractures of the humerus] Cas. ldk. desk., 1933, 72: 1155.—Schaefer, H. Die Bedeutung des Torsionswinkels fiir die Behandlung der Oberarmfrakturen. Arch, orthop. UnfaUchir., 1929, 27: 260- 3.—Sejournet, P. Traitement des fractures de l'humdrus. Clinique, Par., 1930, 25: 233-7. ---- Fracture: Treatment: Apparatus. Alves de Lima, A. *Contribuigao para o tratamento das fracturas do humero pelo appare- lho de Sejournet. 50p. 8? S. Paulo, 1931. Labignette, P. *Traitement des fractures de l'humdrus par la methode de I'appareil ouate. 79p. 8? Par., 1932. Sejournet, J. *Cent quarante-neuf cas de fractures de l'humerus traitds par I'appareil de P. Sejournet. 120p. 8? Par., 1927. Aleksiewicz, J. [Treatment of fractures of the humerus with Slajmer-Lieblein's gutter splint] Polska gaz. lek., 1930, 9: 8; 32; 47; 69; 85; pl.—Atkinson, W. B. Fiucture of the humerus treated with Dr Hendon's bone key; case report. Kentucky M. J., 1933, 31: 526-8.—Bado, J. L., & Vazquez-Rolfi, D. Aparato personal para el tratamiento de las fracturas de humero. Arch. urug. med., 1936, 9: 293-302.—Balogh, E. Eine Extensionsschiene fiir Oberarmfrakturen. Zbl. Chir., 1927, 54: 3029-33.—Bethencourt del Rio. Aparato ambulante del Dr Leyva para tratar las fracturas del humero por la exten- si6n continua. Progr. clin., Madr., 1917, 9: 120-3.—Borchers. Distraktionsbehandlung der Oberarmbruche, insbesondere der suprakondylaren Frakturen Jugendlicher mittels Distraktions- biigel. Arch. klin. Chir., 1929, 157: 720-2 [Discussion] 176-82. ■-----• & Hellge, R. Ueber die Behandlung von Oberarm- briichen mittels Distraktionsbugel und deren Erfolge. Chirurg, 1931, 3: 913-21.—Burk, W. Die rechtwinkhge Abduktions- schiene fur Oberarmbruche und ihre kriegschirurgische Ver- wendbarkeit, Med. Klin., Berl., 1938, 34: 651.—Dellepiane Rawson, J. Sobre un nuevo tipo de aeroplano para el trata- miento de las fracturas del humero. Sem. mdd., B. Air., 1929, 36: 1150-5.—Digby, K. H. The mid-position humerus spUnt. China M. J., 1930, 44: 1009-23.—Faulk. J. W. The use of abduction splints in fractures of the humerus. N. Orleans M. & S. J., 1935-36, 88: 746-50.—Foster, G. S. The Lavoie splint in fractures of the humerus. Am. J. Surg., 1932, 17: 444.—Frenelle, D. de. De 1'appareUlage actuel des fractures de l'humdrus. Paris chir., 1925, 17: 299-302.—Gibson, D. N. The principle of RusseU traction appUed to fractures of the upper half of the humerus. J. Iowa M. Soc, 1940, 30: 152-4.— Guyot, J. De 1'appareiUage actuel des fractures de l'humdrus. P. verb. Congr. fr. chir., 1925, 34: 519-75.—Marian, J. Traite- ment des fractures de l'extrdmitd supdrieure de l'humdrus par I'appareil pl&trd. Bull. Soc. nat. chir., Par., 1927, 53: 305-7.— Masland. H. C. Fracture treatment; humerus splint. Med. World, 1934, 52: 292-5.—Mattuschek, B. [Extension splints for fractures of the humerus] Gyogy&szat, 1929, 68: 562-4.— Monod, R. C. AppareU pour fractures de l'humdrus du Pro- fesseur Pierre Delbet. In Delbet, P.: Oeuvre, Par., 1932, 381-7.—Orestano, F. Un nuovo apparecchio per la eura delle fratture deU'omero (omerostato-Orestano) Cult. med. mod., Pal., 1932, 11: 181-91.—Pascalis, G. Le traitement par 1'appareiUage des fractures de l'humdrus. Paris mdd., 1926, 59: 569.—Rouhier. G., & Labignette, P. L'appareil ouatd de Dujarier dans les fractures de l'humdrus. Presse mdd., 1932, 40: 1418.—Rouvillois, H. AtteUe mdtalUque interchangeable pour le traitement des fractures de l'humdrus (tvpe du Service de Santd) Bull. Soc. nat. chir., Par., 1925, 51: 587-9— Schar, W. AllseiticverBtellbare Oberarmabduktionsschiene. Zbl. Chir., 1933, 60: 2717-9.—Scheiber. V. [New type of plaster bandage for the treatment of humeral fractures] Gy6gy hutnico. Prensa mdd. argent., 1935, 22: 1256-60.—Johnson. R. G. The chemistry of humic acid in relation to e<>:il fonnaticm. Abstr. Theses Univ. Pittsburgh, 1930, 6: 89-90. Miiller. R. Die Humin- sauren und ihre therapeutische Verwendbarkeit. Wien. klin. Wschr.. 1937, 50: 1655.—Niklas, H., & Genninger, C. Oxyda- tionsliisungen von Humussauren und vervaiicltcn StofTen. Kolloid Zschr., 1940, 93: 225-33.—Paulus, R. Perorale Huminsaurebehandhing (Hucomin) Deut. med. Wschr., 1930, 62: 2103.—Scheele, W., & Rowe, W. Leber Humus- sauren; iiber eine Methode zur quantitativen Bestimmung von Humussauren in Extrakten durch konduktometrische Titra- tion. Kolloid Zschr., 1936, 75: 73-9.—Scheele, W., Schuize, W., & Spandau, H. Ueber Humussauren. Ibid., 1935, 72: 301; 73: 84.—Scheele, W., & Steinkc, L. Ueber Humussiiuren. Ibid., 1936, 77: 312-20.—Ssyskoff, K. I. Ueber die Adsorption des Bariumhydroxyds durch die Huminsiiuren. Ibid., 76: 153-9.—Stadnikoff, G. Ueber Huminsiiuren. Ibid., 1937, 80: 60-8.—Thiessen, G. The isolation of the humic acids. Abstr. Theses Univ. Pittsburgh, 1930, 6: 185-90. HUMIDITY; its significance, measurement and control. 27p. illust. 18)^cm. Manchester, Emmott & co., 1939. Forms No. 7, of Mech. World Monogr. HUMIDITY. See also Air, Moisture; Climate. Geisler. Effects of humidity on Drosophila melanogaster pupae. Am. Natur., 1942, 76:223.—Pielou, D. P. The humid- ity behaviour of the mealworm beetle, Tenebrio moUtor L.; trie humidity receptors. J. Exp. Biol., Lond., 1940, 17: 295- 306. ------ & Gunn, D. L. The humidity behaviour of the mealworm beetle, Tenebrio molitor L.; the reaction to differ- ences of humidity. Ibid., 286-94. ------ The humidity behaviour of the mealworm beetle, Tenebrio molitor L.; the mechanism of the reaction. Ibid., 307-16.—Smith, J. W. L'influence de l'humiditd dans la reaction entre le soufre et l'argent. BuU. Soc. chim. France, 1940, 5. sdr., 7: 706-8 (microfilm) HUMIN. See also Humic acid. Bouilloux, G. Interprdtation de quelques nouveaux modes de formation des substances humiques; dtude d'une base humique. Bull. Soc. chim. biol.. Par., 1937, 19: 1654-62. ------ Essai de synthdse totale de substances humiques. Ibid., 1939, 21: 820-6.—Kizel, A., & Kirianova, E. [On humin formation in protein hydrolysis] Biokhimia, Moskva, 1941, 6: 280-3—Lillevik, H. A., & Sandstrorn, W. M. The origin of the humin formed by the acid hydrolysis of proteins; hydrolysis in the presence of djenkoUc and of thiazolidine-4-carboxylic acids. J. Am. Chem. Soc, 1941, 63: 1028-30.—Remy, T.. A Rosing, G. Ueber die biologische Reizwirkung naturlicher Humusstoffe. Zbl. Bakt., 2. Abt., 1911, 30: 349-84.—Scheele, W. Beitrage zur Charakterisierung naturlicher Humusstoffe. KoUoid Beihefte, 1937, 46: 368-424.—Schmid, R. Beitrage zur physiologisch-chemischen (insbesonders H-vitaminahn- lichen) Wirkungsweise von Huminstoffen. Arch. Derm. Syph., Berl., 1937, 175: 344-53. HUMISTON, Charles Edward, 1868-1940. [Obituary] Illinois M. J., 1940, 78: 472, portr. Also J. Am. M. Ass., 1940, 115: 1904. HUML, Anton. *Serum treatment in pneu- monia. 19p. 4? Youngstown [n. pub.] 1938. Typewritten. HUMMEL, Benedikt. *Ueber einen Fall von tumorahnlicher Bildung im Mesocolon trans- versum nach Fettgewebsnekrose [Munchen] 25p. 4 pl. 8? Borna-Lpz., R. Noske, 1927. HUMMEL, Edgar, 1904- *Halt die Irisdiagnose einer ernsthaften Nachpriifung Stand? 28p. 8? Bresl. [n. pub.] 1936. HUMMEL, Esther, 1909- *Die Stau- ungsniere. 19p. 23cm. Lpz., A. Edelmann, 1936. HUMMEL, Helmut, 1913- *Versuche iiber die antiphlogistische Wirkung von Atophan und einigen atherischen Oelen. 35p. 8? Tub., Bolzle, 1937. HUMMEL 897 HUMPERDINCK HUMMEL, Hermann, 1907- *Die ver- schiedenen Infektionstheorien bei marginaler Paradentitis. 22p. 8! Wiirzb., Gebr. Mem- minger, 1932. HUMMEL, Hermann, 1912- *Die Be- deutung der Diastasebestimmung nach Wohlge- muth in Harn und Blut fiir die klinische Dia- gnostik. 91p. 20#cm. Bonn, H. Trapp, 1937. HUMMEL, Karla, 1911- *Ueber Ein- schlussblennorrhoe der Neugeborenen [Miin- chen] 16p. 8? Wiirzb., R. Mayr, 1936. HUMMEL, Rudolf, 1902- *Ueber grosse stielgedrehte Ovarialtumoren. 35p. 8? [Bonn, n. p.] 1925. HUMMER, Richard, 1907- *Wochen- bettverlaufe bei Gonorrhoe. 23p. 8? Bresl., A. Schreiber, 1932. HUMMING bird. See Trochilidae. HUMOR. See also Caricature; Feeling; Personality. Barry, H., jr. The role of subject-matter in individual differences in humor. J. Cenet. Psychol., 1928, 35: 112-28.— Bender, L., & Lourie, R. S. The effect of comic books on the ideology of children. Am. J. Orthopsychiat., 1941, 11: 540- 50.—Bergler, E. A cUnical contribution to the psychogenesis of humor. Psychoanal. Rev., 1937, 24: 34-53.—Brill," A. A. The mechanisms of wit and humor in normal and psvchopathic states. Psychiat. Q., 1940. 14: 731-49.—Coriat, I. H. Humor and hypomania. Ibid., 1939, 13: 681-8.—Deitchman, L. S. Medical sketches. Ohio M. J., 1941, 37: 660.—Diserens, C. M., & Bonifield, M. Humor and the ludicrous. Psychol. Bull., 1930, 27: 108-18.—Egner, F. Humor und Witz unter strukturpsychologischem Gesichtspunkt. Arch. ges. Psychol., 1932, 84: 330-71.—Eysenck, H. J. The appreciation of humour; an experimental and theoretical study. Brit. J. Psychol., 1941-42, 32: 295-309.—Freud, S. Der Humor. Imago, Wien, 1928, 14: 1-6. Also Internat. J. Psychoanal., Lond., 1928, 9: 1-6.—Heim, A. An experiment of humour. Brit. J. Psychol., 1936, 27: 148-61.—Jastrow, J. Sense of humor. In his Getting More Out of Life, N. Y., 1940, 283- 90.—Jekels, L. Zur Psvchologie der Komodie. Imago, Wien, 1926, 12: 328-35.—K., R. G., S., M. E. [et al.] The funniest experience in mv practice. N. York Physician, 1940, 14: No. 5, 28.—Landis, C., & Ross, J. W. H. Humor and its relation to other personality traits. J. Social Psychol., 1933, 4:156-75.—Mackay, N. D. The lighter side of general practice. Caledon. M. J., 1937-38, 16: 175-84.—Maier, N. R. F. A gestalt theory of humour. Brit. J. Psychol., 1932, 23: 69.— Mones, L. Intelligence and a sense of humor. J. Except. Child., 1938-39. 5: 150-3.—Murray, H. A., jr. The psychology of humor; mirth responses to disparagement jokes as a mani- festation of an aggressive disposition. J. Abnorm. Psvchol., 1934, 29: 66-81.—Obrdlik, A. J. Gallows humor, a sociological phenomenon. Am. J. Sociol, 1941-42, 47: 709-16.—Omwake, L. Factors influencing the sense of humor. J. Social Psvchol., 1939, 10: 95-104.—Perl, R. E. The influence of a .social factor upon the appreciation of humor. Am. J. Psychol., 1933, 45: 308-12.—Reik, T. Zur Psvchoanalyse des judischen Witzes. Imago, Wien, 1929, 15: 03-88.—Rossi, M. M. Sulla natura psicologica del comico. Riv. psicol., 1926, 22: 22-32 — Schleicher, I. Lachende Medizin. Schweiz. med. Wschr., 1941, 71: 1407.—Stolinsky, A. Wit, and humor in the medical profession. Med. Rec, N. Y., 1941, 154: No. 12, 22.—Stump, N. F. Sense of humor and its relationship to personality, scholastic aptitude, emotional maturity, height, and weight. J. Gen. Psychol., 1939, 20: 25-32.—Winterstein. A. Con- tributions to the problem of humor. Psychoanal. Q , 1934, 3: 303-16.—Wolff, H. A., Smith, C. E., & Murray, H. A. The psychology of humor; a study of responses to race-disparage- ment jokes. J. Abnorm. Psychol., 1934, 28: 341-65. HUMOR [of body] See Body fluid; also under proper names of humors as Aqueous; Blood; etc. HUMORAL pathology. See under Pathology. HUMPE, Franz, 1909- *Hirntumor und Trauma [Munster] 33p. 21cm. Bottrop, W. Postberg, 1938. HUMPERDINCK, Carl, 1905- *Ein Beitrag zur Frage der Bindegewebsvermehrung 227475—VOL. 7, 4th series----57 in chronischen Stauungslebern [Kiell 32d 8° Giessen, R. Lange, 1931 HUMPHREY, George, 1889- The nature ol learning in its relation to the living svstem vii, 296p diagrs. 8? Lond., K. Paul, Trench; Trubner & co., 1933. Sref '^J80^?"1, J„eoan Marc Gaspard. The wild boy of Avev- ron [&c.J 104p. 8? N. Y. [1932] y HUMPHREY, John Thurlbeck, 1862- Drugs in commerce; their source, preparation for the market, and description, xi, 116p illu-4 18^cm. X. Y., Pitman & sons [1921] HUMPHREY, Muriel Miller. See Hard, Jean Marc Gaspard. The wild boy of Aveyron [&c] 104p. 8? N. Y. [1932] HUMPHREY, Norton R. *The blood sedi- mentation rate in the puerperium [St. Mary's Hosp.] 15 1. 28cm. [Milwaukee] 1939. Typewritten. HUMPHREYS, Frederick, 1816-1900. Hum- phreys' homeopathic mentor or family adviser in the use of specific homeopathic medicine vi, 364p. 8? N. Y., Humphreys' Spec. Homeop. Med. co., 1872. ---- [The same] Mentor homeop&tico de Humphreys o gufa de las familias en el uso de la medicina especffica homeopdtica. vi, 448p. 8? N. Y., Humphreys' Spec. Homeop. Med. co , 1886. ---- [The same] Mentor do Dr Humphreys, ou, Conselheiro da familia, para uso da medicina especifica. iv, 462p. 8? N. Y., Humphreys' Homeop. Med. co., 1890. Also another ed. 12? N. Y. [1927] HUMPHREYS, Humphrey. See Mills, G. Percival, & Humphreys, H. A text-book of surgery for dental students. 4. ed. 342p. 8? Lond. [1935] HUMPHRIS, Francis Howard, 1866- Artificial sunlight and its therapeutic uses. 4. ed. xix, 306p. front. 3 pl. 8? Lond., Oxford univ. press [1928] Also 5. ed. xxi, 340p. 8° [1929] ---- & STUART-WEBB, Ralph E. Physio- therapy; its principles and practice; with con- tributions by Frank Romer, A. E. Hayward Pinch and A. Gordon Watson. 384p. 8? Lond., J. Cape [1930] HUMPHRIS, Francis Howard, & WILLIAMS, Leonard Llewelyn Bulkeley. Emanotherapy. ix, 188p. diagrs. 8? Bait., W. Wood & co., 1937. HUMPHRY, Sir George Murray, 1820-96. [Biography] Cat. Porter. R. Coll. Surgeons, Lond., 1930, 80.—Rolleston, H. Sir George Murray Humphry, M. D., F. R. S., Professor of anatomy (1866-83) and of surgery (1883- 96) in the University of Cambridge, England. Ann. M. Hist., 1927, 9: 1-11. For portrait, photograph, see Collection in Library. HUMPHRY, Laurence, 1856- Humphry and Reynolds nurse's service digest; a manual of nursing; 1. Am. ed. xii, 407p. illust. charts. 17cm. X. Y., Menzies pub. co., 1918. HUMULUS. See also Beer. Helwing, H. *Beitriige zur Pharmakologie des Hopfens. 27p. 8? Wiirzb., 1931. Hochstadter, E. *Beitrage zur Pharma- kologie des Hopfens. 20p. 8? Wurzb., 1931. Vogel, H. *Beitrage zur Pharmakologie des Hopfens. 25p. 8? Wurzb., 1931. Braun, H. Die Bedeutung des Baldrians und des Hopfens in der Therapie. Fortsch. Med., 1939, 57: 353-7.—Del hombrecillo v de sus productos y preparados medicinales. Diar. gen. cienc. mid., Barcel., 1827, 3: 177-85.— Gronberg, J., & Staven-Gronberg, A. Die hypnotische und sedative Wirkung des Hopfens. Ther. Gegenwart, 1927, 68: 389-91 — Lecierc, H. La pharmacologie du houbion (Humulus lupulus HUMULUS 898 HUNDERTMARK L.) Pn-'se m6d., 1934, 42: 1052.- I.ermer. Principe cristallisl du houl'i"ii. J. chim. med., Pai.. 1865, 5. s6r., 1: 201.— Lewith. K. Feber Hopfendermatiti*. Arch. Derm. Syph., Berl.. 192S. 151: 345-51.—Neumann, W. Tierexperimentelles und KlmiM-he* iiber Hopfen-Valeriana-Extrakte. Wien. med. Wschr., 1933, S3: 571-3.—Staven-Gronbertf. A. Ueber die Wirkungen der Hopfensubstanzen bei FroM lien. Arch. exp. Path., Lpz., 1927, 123: 272-81. ■------ Clinical studies on the somniferous influence of drugs derived from hops. Acta Soc. med. Duodecim, 1929, 11: fase. 2, No. 6, 1-26.—Steidle, H. Zur Pharmakologie des Hopfens. Arch. exp. Path., Lpz., 1931, 161: 154-62. HUMUS. See also Humic acid; Humin; Soil. Lwoff, A., & Lederer, E. Remarques sur l'extrait de terre envisage comme facteur de croissance pour les flagell£s. C. rend. Soe. biol.. 1935, 119: 971-3.—Sorokina, A. V., & Tiagny Riadno, M. G. [Role of microorganisms in the process of humus formation] Mikrobiologia, Moskva, 1932, 2: 28">- 91.—Stoughton, R. H. Humus from habitation wastes. Nature, Lond.. 1941, 147:457. HUN, Andre Jules Auguste, 1909- *Le traitement des cervicites chroniques par la diathermocoagulation. 79p. 25cm. Xancy C. Andre, 1934. HUN, Henry, 1854- Syllabus of a course of lectures on the diseases of the nervous system designed as a note book for the use of students. 2v. 282p.; 423p. 8? Albany, N. Y., Wm. A. Stetson, 1901-2. ----An atlas of the differential diagnosis of the diseases of the nervous system (with a physiological introduction) analytical and semeio- logical neurological charts. 3. rev. 3 p. 1. 298p. illust. pl. ch. diagr. 28£cm. Troy, X. Y., Southworth, co., 1922. Hl'NAIN ibn Ishaq al-Tbadi, 809-877. See 'Ibadi. HUNAN, China. Medical coordination demonstrated in Hunan. Northwest M., 1942, 41: 140. HUNAULD, Francois, 1701-42. [Biographie] Arch. mid. Angers, 1937, 41: 127. HUNAULD, Pierre, 1664-1728. [Biographie] Arch. mid. Angers, 1937, 41 : 126. HUNCZEK, Franz, 1895- *Die Ergebnisse der letzten 100 Interruptionen an der Breslauer Universitats-Frauenklinik. 17p. 8? Bresl., A. Schreiber, 1928. HUND, Alexander, 1890- *Ueber einen Fall von Riesenzellbildung bei bestrahltem Portiocarcinom [Jena] 26p. 8? Lpz., R. Xoske, 1935. HUND, Frieda, 1912- *Zur tangentialen Projektion im Rontgenbdd des Schadeldachs. 14p. 21cm. Wurzb., C. J. Becker, 1936. HUND, Walter, 1907- lymphogranulo- matosis inguinalis, klimatische Bubonen und Ulcus chronicum elephantiasticum ani. 17p. 8? Freiburg i. B., H. M. Muth, 1931. HUNDE MER, Kurt, 1905- *Ueber psy- chische und neurologische Storungen bei Reckling- hausenscher Krankheit [Munchen] 54p. 8! Kallmiinz, M. Lassleben, 1930. HUNDEMER, Wilhelm, 1906- *Ein Volvulus des Meckel'schen Divertikels [Miin- chen] 36p. 8? Kallmiinz, M. Lassleben, 1932. HUNDERTMARCK [Ernst] Werner, 1897- *Die an der Leipziger Frauenklinik von 1912 bis 1922 behandelten und beobachteten Fterusrupturen [Leipzig] 79p. 8? [Zeulen- roda, A. Oberreuter] 1926. HUNDERTMARK, Helene, 1903- ♦Ur- sachen, Verlauf und Ausgange des Ulcus serpens nach den Erkrankungen in der Tiibinger Augen- klinik von 1928-31 [Tubingen] 30p. s Wiirzb., K. Triltsch, 1934. HINDHAUSEN, Josef, 1901 *Ein Beitrag zur Entstehung des Karcinoms auf dem Boden einer chronischen Osteomyelitis. 5f>p 8? Bonn, P. Kubens, 1930. HUNDRISSER, Hermann, 1909- bei- trag zur Frage der Keratosis multilocularis beziehungsweise der Atypien der Keratosis palmoplantaris transgrediens. 43p. 4 pl 8° Munch., O. Boeck, 1936. HUNDT, Fritz, 1905- *Der Mogaoeso- phagus und seine Behandlung unter Hinweis auf einen besonderen Fall. 24p. 8? Marb J Hamel, 1933. HUNDT, Hans, 1909- *Ein biologischer Altersindex. 32p. 22cm. Bonn, A. Brand, 1936 HUNDT, Hugo, 1911- *Die bei Kombi- nation von Alba-P-Legierung mit Amalgamen, Feingold, V2a-Stahl in verschiedenen Elektroly- ten auftretenden Potentialdifferenzen. 24p 21cm. Berl., Silesia, 1937. HUNDT, Otto, 1909- *Die Ergebnisse der Weltliteratur iiber die Behandlung der Collumcarcinome von 1925-30 [Berlin] " 15p 21 >^cm. Wurzb., R. Mayr, 1937. HUNDT, Otto, 1913- *ErfoIge der Wiederherstellungs-Chirurgie bei Unfallverletz- ten. 24p. 20y2cm. Heidelb., H. Fahrer, 193S. HUNECKE, Josef, 1908- *Die Moglich- keit des verschiedenartigen Zahnersatzes im Frontzahnbereich und seine Indikation [Munster] 20p. 8? Soest, J. Flory, 1937. HUNECKE, Werner, 1909- ♦Unter- suchungen iiber die Moglichkeit einer Augen- diagnose beim Rind. 32p. 8? Lpz., A. Edel- mann, 1935. HUNEKE, Ferdinand. Krankheit und Heilung anders gesehen. 2. Aufl. 103p. 8? Koln, Staufen-Verl., 1937. HUNGARY. Magyar Foldrajzi Tarsasag. Foldrajzi kozlemenyek. Budap., v.69, No 1 1941- HUNGARY. Magyar Kiralyi Kozponti Sta- tisztikai Hivatal. Annuaire statistique. Budap., n. ser., v.5, (1897-) 1899- ---- Mouvement de la population. Budap. (1900/1/2-1926/32) 1905-37. ---- Magyar statisztikai szemle [monthly] Budap., v.5, 1927- RScensement general de la population de 1930. 11 pt. Budap,, 1933-36. ---- Statistique des etudiants des ecoles superieures hongroises. Budap. (1931/32-1933/34) lyoo—oo. ---- Statisztikai havi kozlemenyek. Budap., v.37, 1934- H ---- Recensement de la population, de la propriety fonciere et du cheptel, en 1938, dans la zone nord recouvree. 281p. 26^cm. Budap., Impr. Stephaneum, 1939. HUNGARY, M. Kir. Orszagos Kozegesz- segugyi Intezet. Oesszegviijtott kozlemenyek. Budap., v.l, 1927- ---- Jelentes. Budap., v.8-10 (1934-36) 1935-37. HUNGARY. Magyar Urologiai Tarsasag. Magyar urologia. Budap., v.l, 1938- HUNGARY [and Hungarians] See also names of Hungarian cities. Danubian review. Budap., v.l, 1934- Felbermann, L. Hungary and its people. 2. ed. 390p. 8? Lond. [193-] HUNGARY 899 HUNGARY Magyar Tudomanyos Akademiai Almanach, 1931. 213p. 8? [Budap.] 1931. Barlucz, L. [La composition raciale du peuple hongrois] Magy. statiszt. szemle, 1939, 17: 337-49. 3 pl.—Beynon, E. D. Social mobility and social distance among Hungarian immigrants in Detroit. Am. J. Sociol., 1953-36, 41: 423-34—Elekes, D. Vie intellectuellc. Magy. statiszt. szemle, 1938, 16: 528-34, ch —Kolosvarv, G. Studi eoologico-faunistiei nella Pannonia meridionale (Ungheria) Riv. biol., 1937, 23: 1-13.—Mal an, M. Zur Augen- und Haarfarbe der Ungarn. Verh. Deut. Ges. Rassenforsch., 1938, 9: 99-105.—New law on protection of the Magyar race. J. Am. M. Ass., 1911, 117: 2089.—Sziraky, S., & Huszar, G. Beitrage zur Anthropologie Ungarns im XI. Jahrhundert. Mitt. Anthrop. Ges. Wien, 1933, 63: 229-32. ---- Hygiene. Baciu, A. Das Gesundheitswesen in Ungarn. Zschr. Gesundh verwalt., 1932, 3: 129-33—Bela. J. L'organisation des services ruraux d'hygidne publique en Hongrie. In Probl. san. pop. rurale Rom&nia, Bucur., 1910, 997-1002.—Daranyi, G. [Sixtieth anniversary of the Institute for Public Hygiene at the Universityl Orvosk6pz6s, 1935, 25: 150-3.—Hepp-Bajan, E. [Official villaga physicians and the public health adminis- tration] N6peg6szs£gugy, 1937, 18: 66-73.—[Hungary] [Order Xo. 100-1940. B. M. for regulation of the service of malaria ■stations] Ibid., 1940, 21: 179.—Johann. Unsrarische Oesund- heitsfiihrun-. Klin. Wschr., 1940, 19: 900 (microfilm)— Melly. J. [Public health in Hungary (1932)] Orv. hetil, 1932, 76: 284-7.—Neuber, E. [Health survev of children of the heroes of Hajdii County in 1936-37] Ibid., 1937, 81: 1237- f>5.—Petrilla, A. [Gesundheitsverhaltnisse in Ungarn im Jahre 1936] Orsz. K6zeg6szs. Int. kozl., 1937, 10: No. 21, 1-5.— Scholtz, K. [Reminiscences, experiences] N6pegeszsegiigy, 1939, 20: 10-21.—Szel, T. Donnees principales sur le mouve- ment demographique et l'etat sanitaire des villages en Hongrie, d'aprte les statistiques de ces derniers temps. In Probl. san. pop. rurale Romania, Bucur., 1940, 1003-10.—Teglassy, B. [Reform of social hygiene [in Hungary]] Orv. hetil., 1933, 77: 388-90.—Thirring, L. Halalozasok kor 6s honapok szerint. Magy. statiszt. szemle, 1939, 17: 1247-53. ---- Language. Yolland, A. B., comp. A dictionary of the Hungarian and English languages. 2v. 577p.; 463p. 19^cm. Budap. [1924] ---- Medicine. Gy6ry, T. A magyar orvosi irodalom, 1904. 8? Budap., 1905. Soi'r, J. *Geographie medicale de la Transyl- vanie. 83p. 8? Par., 1935. Alfoldi, B. Riief aus Ungarn. Deut. med. Wschr., 193." 61: 1523—Alwall, N. [Impressions from an educational trip to Hungary] Sven. lak. tidn., 1938, 35: 3-10—Atzel, E. [Physicians'' Chamber (Hungarian) bill] Gy6gyaszat, 1932, 72:258-61.—Banky, E. H. Traveling to Magyarland. Bull. Nurs. Alumnae Ass. Univ. Maryland, 1940, 33-6. ------ Homeward bound from a foreign land. Ibid., 37-40.—Blazso. A. L'organisation de la medecine; la nouvelle loi sur le syndicat medical en Hongrie (La Chambre medicale hongroise) Presse med. 1936, 44: 443-5.—Csillery, D. Die ungarische Aerzte- Organisation, Mone. Klin. Wschr., 1940, 19: 900 (microfilm) — Grosz, E. Die neue Prufungsordnung fiir Aerzte und das praktische Jahr in Ungarn. Klin. Jahrb., 1907, 17: 481-5. ------ [The seventh Hungarian medical week] Orv. hetil., 1937 81: 635-7.—Gyory, T. Das medizinische Leben m Budapest bzw. in Ungarn. Zschr. arztl. Fortbild 1915, 12: 669-71.—Harbitz, H. [Impressions from a student trip to Budapest] Norsk, mag. laegevid., 1936, 97: 888-94. Jourdan, P. La chirurgie au delk des fronticre.s Vienne- Budapest, printemps, 1935. Hopital, 1935, 23: 547; 559 — Manninger. W. Budapester Brief. Deut. med. Wschr., 1938, 64: 830. ------ Brief aus Ungarn; Ziele und Wege der Einheitsbestrebungen in der Medizin. Ibid., 1939, 65: 1319.— Medical practice in Bolshevist Hungary. Lancet, Lond., 1920 1-168 —Nyman, P. [Certain impressions from a student trip to Hungary] Sven. farm, tskr., 1937, 41: 381; 399; 417.— Oliver T Some social and medical institutions of Hungary. Brit M J 1914, 1: 870-2.—Puder, S. [Distribution of physicians' offices at Budapest] Orv. hetil 1937, 81: 539 — Survey of Budapest physicians. J. Am. M. Ass., 1930, 107: 1735—Zemplenyi. I. [Objects of the chamber of medicine] Orv. hetil., 1936, 80: 28. ---- Medicine: History. Magyary-Kossa, Gy. Magyar orvosi emlekek; ertekezesek a magyar orvostortenelem korebdl. 3v. 8? Budap., 1929-31. ____ Ungarische medizinische Ermnerungen [Selected parts transl. from his Magyar orvosi emlekek] 368p. 8? Budap., 1935. Mayer, C. F. Das Zeitalter der Monchs- und Pnestermedizin in Ungarn. 354-94p. 8° Lnz 1930. ' ' ' " Reprint from Kyklos, Bd 3, 1930. n ^Hruh l^ JPh/sicians of Matthias, King of Hungary (1458-90)] Gyogyaszat, 1932, 72: 76-8.—Dollinger, J. Die Markusovszky'sehe Tischgesellschaft. Wien. med Wschr 1935, 85: 310-2.—Elekes, G. [In the interest of the history of Hungarian medicine] Orv. hetil., 1938, 82: 1077-9.—Grosz E [Centenary of the meetings of Hungarian doctors] Ibid 1940* 84: 629.—Liszt, N. Szemelv6nyek regi magyar tudonianvos 6s n6pies orvosi munkakbol. Gvogvaszat, 1906 46- 831- 874; 1907, 47: 131; 164; 519.—Magyary-Kossa, Gy. Ana- baptista orvosok Magyarorszagon. Ibid., 1907, 47: 486. ------ A r£gi magyar orvos czime. Ibid., 1908, 48: 257-9 ------[Old Hungarian encomia] Orv. hetil., 1937, 81: 1045-7. ---— [Physician of Rakoczi] Ibid., 261-3.------ Medizinischer Fachunterricht und Universitatsleben im alten Ungarn. In his Ungar. med. Erinner., Bpest, 1935, 1-45. ------Aerztliche Praxis im einstigen Ungarn. Ibid., 46-69. —----Der Chirurg des Konira Matthias Corvinus. Ibid., 180-91. ------ Ein Miirtyrer. Ibid., 276-83. ------ Kleinere Angaben und Bemerkungen; fin der Zeitfolge) Ibid., 344-63.—Mayer, C. F. [Societies of the Hungarian barber surgeons] Orv. hetil., 1925, 69: 1118-20. ------ [Physicians and the like of the 17th and 18th century in Budapest,: Matricula civium Pesthiensium] Ibid., 1928, 72: 280-8.—Nekam, L. [History of the Medical faculty (Budapest); review 1770-1935] Orv. hetil., 1937, 81: 213-0.—Petrescu, G. Z. Aus dem Leben der Siebenbiirger deutschen Wundarzte im 16. Jahrhundert. Wien. med. Wschr., 1928, 78: 1581-5. ---- Statistics. Budapest Szekesfovaros Statisztikai Hi- vatala. Budapest szekesfovaros statisztikai es kozigazgatasi evkonyve. 4? Budap., v.20, 1932- ---- A fovaros polgari nepessegenek szocialis es gazdasagi viszonyai [Die sozialen und wirt- schaftlichen Verhaltnisse der burgerlichen Be- volkerung in Budapest] 1119p. 8? Budap., 1935. Hungary. Office Central Royal Hon- grois de Statistique. Annuaire statistique Hongrois. Budap., v.5-41, 1897-1935. ---- Recensement general de la population de 1930; 2. pt: Donnees sur les professions suivant les communes et les lieux habites ex- terieurs, puis sur les grands etablissements in- dustriels et commerciaux. 492p. 8? Budap., 1935. ---- Recensement general de la population en 1930. 3. pt: Resultats detailles sur les professions et statistique des etablissements. 261p. 8? Budap., 1935. ---- Recensement general de la population • en 1930; 4. pt: Les professions exercees par la population, combinees avec les principales donnees demographiques; 5. pt: demographie detaillee. 377p. 8? Budap., 1936. ---- Mouvement de la population en 1926-32. v. p. 8? Budapest, 1937. Pub. statist, hongroises, n. s. 96. ---- Recensement de la population, de la propriet6 fonciere et du cheptel, en 1938, dans la zone nord recouvree. 281p. 26V>cm. Budap., 1939. Statisztikai havi kozlemenyek. Budap., v.37, 1934. Balas, K. Nyersanyag es n6pesedes. Magy. statiszt. szemle, 1940, 18: 465-70.—Bandi, A. [Vital statistical data of a district in the north of Transylvanial Nepegfezsegugy, 1941, 22: 292-4.—[Births, deaths and mairiages statistics for Hungary in 1933] Rihhiye mecmuasi, 1933. 9: 346.—Kovacs, A. Die Ergebnisse der Volkszahlung vom Jahre 1910 in Ungarn. Arch, sozial. Hvg., 1910, 11: 273-306.------Das neue ungarische statistische Gesetz. Allg. statist. Arch., 1929, 19: 235-9.------[Les effets de la d^croissance, pendant la guerre, de la natality en Hongrie] Magy. statiszt. szemle, 1936, 14: 577-87.—Lukacs, C. A balatonmel!6k nepesedese. Ibid.', 1941, 19: 94-104.—-Mike, G. Les Hongrois du monde. Ibid!! 1938, 16: 368-72.—Mouvement de la population, mariages, naissances vivantes, d<5ces pour toutes causes, accroissement naturel de la population; repartition des deces selon les causes pour 100 d£c£s; taux de mortality par causes de d6ces pour 1,000 habitants; annees 1931-36. Bull. Oil. HUNGARY 900 HUNGER internat. hyg. pub., Par., 1938, 30: 2820-3.—Oesszefoglal6 helvzetjelentes; 1940; mAjus havi adatok. Magy. statiszt. szemle, 1940, 18: 537-50.—Petrilla. A. [Vital statistical data of Hungary for 1936] N6pegeszsegiiy, 1937, 18: 260- 3.------[Vital statistical data for the year 1937] Ibid., 193S, 19: 352-5. ------ [Vital statistical data for 1939] Ibid., 1940, 21: 651-5. ------ [Vital statistical data for 1940f Ibid., 1941, 22: 490-502.—Pfeifer, N. Die Bewegung der Bevolkerung in Ungarn in den Jahren 1920-25. Arch. sozial Hyg., 1926-27, n. F., 2: 46-8.—Ronai, A. [Les condi- tions d^mographiques de la Transylvanie] Magy. statiszt. szemle, 1939, 17: 350-60.—Szfil, T. Les statistiques recentes de vieillards. Ibid., 1938, 16: 95-114.—Thirring, L. Popu- lation et mouvement de la population. Ibid., 375-90, map, 2 ch. ------ Torvenyes elveszuletesek 1937-ben is 1938- ban az anya dletkora, a hazassagkot^s eve es a szuletesi sorrend szerint. Ibid., 1940, 18: 267-86. ------ Terulet <5s nepsu- riiaig torv6nyhatos£gonkint. Ibid., 1941, 19: 611-6. HUNGATE, Robert Edward, 1906- See Burlingame, Leonas Lancelot, Giese, Arthur C, & Hungate. Robert E. General biology laboratory manual. N. Y. [1931] HUNGER [Erich] Karl, 1909- *Ueber die Hernia diaphragmatica vera und spuria [Halle] 33p. 22cm. Wurzb., R. Mayr, 1936. HUNGER, Richard, 1906- *Erfahrungen mit der Lebertherapie bei Exanthemen nach Salvarsan und Wismut [Jena] 19p. 1 1. 8? Borna-Lpz., R. Noske, 1935. HUNGER. See also Appetite; Deficiency disease; Famine; Fasting; Inanition; Malnutrition; Starvation. Gumpert, M. Heil hunger! Health under Hitler [2. print.] 128p. 22/2cm. N. Y. [1940] Carlson, A. J. Hunger. Sc. Month., 1931, 33: 77-9 — De Boer. S. Der Hunger. Deut. med. Wschr., 1928, 54: 1499-501.—Hidden hunger. N. England J. M., 1941, 225: 883.—Morhardt, P. E. La faim. Vie mid., 1932, 13: 709.— Pi Suner, A. La faim. In Traite physiol. (Roger, G. H.) Par., 1931, 2: 77-88.—Pletnev, A. V., & Potapova, I. T. [Hunger, appetite and satiation (food reflexes and food behaviour)] Biull. eksp. biol. med., 1941, 11: 211-4.—Sibuya. H. Versuch an )iun;:enideii Kaninchen. Tohoku J. Exp. M., 1938, 34: 571-^.").—Skinner, B. F. A method of maintaining an arbitrary degiee of hunger. J. Comp. Psychol., 1940, 30: 139-45.— Van de Water, M. Hungers show body needs. Science News Lett., 1940, 38: 330. ---- morbid. Baumann, E. D. Ueber die Boulinos und die Fames canina. Janus, Leyden, 1935, 39: 165-74— Critchley, M., & Hoffman, H. L. The syndrome of periodic somnolence and morbid hunger: Kleine-Levin syndrome. Brit. M. J., 1942, 1: 137-9.—Levin, M. Periodic sornmolence and morbid hunger: a new syndrome. Brain, Lond., 1930, 59: pt 4, 494-504.------Morbid hunger in relation to narcolepsy and epilepsy. J. Nerv. Ment. Dis., 1938, 88: 414-6.—Mackwood, J. Periodic somnolence and morbid hunger. Brit. M. J., 1942, 1: 235. Schrijver, J. Fames canina. Ned. tschr. geneesk., 1926, 70: 909-74. ---- Pathology. See also Duodenal ulcer; Peptic ulcer. Christensen, O. Pathophysiology of hunger pains; gastrographic and titrimetric investiga- tions. 170p. 8? Kbh., 1931. Beumer, H., & Peters, H. Zur Frage der Hungerketonurie bei Sauglingen. Zsehr. Kinderh., 1934, 56: 61-3.—Ceconi, A. Le malattie del ricambio; disturbi della nutrizione: da carenza alimentare totale. Minerva med., Tor., 1928, 8: 1571-85.— Heymann, W.t & Maier, E. Zur Frage der Hungerketonurie bei Sauglingen. Zschr. Kinderh., 1934, 56: 280.—Hoppe, F. Kriegsjugend und Hungerfolgen. Arch, sozial Hyg., 1926-27, n. F., 2: 534-45.—Hunger cramps. Time, March 3, 1941 (clipping)—Lafora, G. R. Sobre el hambre y la anorexia de origen cerebral. Ciencia, Mix., 1940, 1: 8-18.—Levit, S., & Dubinsky, A. [Acidosis during hunger] Klin, med., Moskva, 1927, 5: 957-60.—Martin, C. L., & Rogers, F. T. Hunger pain. Am. J. Roentg., 1927, n. ser., 17: 222-7. Also repr.— Meyer, L. F., & Rosenstern, J. Die Wirkung des Hungers in den verschiedenen Stadien der Ernahrung^storung. Jahrb Kinderh., 1909, 69: 167-84.—Monauni, J. Ueber den Hunger- schmerz. Wien. med. Wschr., 1939, 39: 67.—Morgulis" S. Phvsiologje und Pathologie des Hungers. Verh. Ges Ver- dauungskr. (1928) 1929, 8: 31-8.—Moynihan, B. G. A., Maylard, A. E., & Herschell. G. The diagnostic value of hunger pain. Brit, M. J., 1939, 1: 814.—Ossinovsky. N. I. [Hunger and hunger edema in young children during the war] J. Izuch. rann. detsk. vozr., 1929, 9: 9-15.—Porges, O. Be- merkungen zu Genese der Hungerschmerzen und ihre Bedeutung von Prof. Dr Heinrich Sehur. Wien. klin. Wschr., 1922, 35: 791 —Richter, P. F. Hunger und Unterei nahrung. Deut, med. Wschr., 1928, 54: 1007-71--Sternberg. M. Hunger- osteomalazie durch Vigantol geheilt. Wien. klin. Wsehr., 1928, 41: 681.—Ueyama, Y. Beitriigc zur Pathologie des Hungers. Tr. Jap. Path. Soc, 1927, 17: 351-4. ---- Physiology. Boger, A. *Ueber den Einfluss des Hungers auf die H-Ionen-Konzentration des Urins [Frei- burg i. B.] 28p. 8? Ueberlinger, 1926. Patterson, T. L. Comparative physiology of the gastric hunger mechanism, p.55-272. 8! N. Y., 1933. Witsch, K. *Untei .suehungen iiber die Organ- veranderungen und das Stoffwechselgeschehen im Hungerzustand [Bonn] p. 185-212. 8? Berl., 1925. Abderhalden, E. Studien iiber das Hungerstadium an Hand der A.-R. Fermentforschung, 1938-39, 16: 95-7. ------ & Wertheimer, E. Einfluss des Hungerzustandes und anschlics- sender Eiweisszufuhr auf die Bildung von Mercaptursiiure, Zschr. physiol. Chem., 19.31, 201: 267-72.—Adlercreutz, E. Zur Kenntnis der C-Produktion wahrend des ersten Hunger- tages. Skand. Arch. Physiol., Berl., 1926, 48: 129-37.— Albertoni, P. Ricerche sulle variazioni di eccitabiliti del vago e dell'apparecchio vasomotore, e contributo alia fisiologia del digiuno. Arch. sc. biol., Nap., 1924, G: 423-45.—Andrejew, S. W., & Nikoljskaja, M. J. Die motorische Funktion der oberen Dunndarmabschnitte bei anhaltendem Hungern. Arch. ges. Physiol., 1934, 234: 756-60.—Arkhangelsky, V. M. [Higher complicated nervous activity of animals (dogs) in relative quantitative hunger] J. eksp. biol., 1929, 13: 5-13.— Blacher, I. I. [Content of glutathione in the blood in hunger] Arkh. pat. anat., Moskva, 1940, 6: 137-43.—Brugsch. T. Der Stoffwechsel bei Hunger und Unterernahrung. In Handb. Biochem. (Oppenheimer, C.) 2. Aufl., Jena, 1936, Erganz., 3: 131-9.—Chukicheva, M. N. [Effect of fractions of purin bases of products of acid hydrolysis of fibrin and leucocytes on the hunger activitv of the stomach] Arkh. biol. nauk, 1939, 53: No. 2-3, 36-46.—D'Angelo. S. A.. Gordon, A. S., & Charipper, H. A. A study of pituitary-adrenal-thyroid function in the starved guinea pig. Anat. Rec, 1941, 81: Suppl., 96 (Abstr.)— Dmochowski. A. Changes in the nuclear-plasmic ratio of vertebrate poikilotherms during hunger. Biochem. J., Lond., 1928, 22: 1548-54. ------ Changes in the nuclear-plasmic ratio of mammals during hunger. Ibid., 1555-61.—Edlbacher, S. Untersuchungen uber den Puringehalt der Organe bei Hunger und einseitiger Ernahrung. In Festschrift (E. C. Barell) Basel, 1936, 32-40.—Fasold, H. Beitrage zum Saure- Basen-Haushalt; Uber die Bedeutung der organischen Sanren im Urin wahrend des Hungers. Zschr. Kinderh., 1930, 50: 367-73.—Fogelson, L. I., & Shevliagina, M. I. [Effect of hunger on the cardiovascular system] Med. biol. J., Leningr., 1928, 4: 24-9.—Hatafuku, J. Studien iiber den Wasser- haushalt beim Hunger; Wasserhaushalt normalen Tieren beim Hunger. Tohoku J. Exp. M., 1933, 21: 13-42. ------ Be: einflussung des Wasserhaushaltes durch den Hunger bei hyperthyreotischen Tieren. Ibid., 43-76.— Hayakawa, Y. [Ueber den Einfluss der Inanition und Hypovitaminosen (Vitamin B, C) auf das Blutbild der gesunden Kaninchen] Mitt. Med. Ges. Osaka, 1941, 40: 25; 133.—Hiller, S. [Hunger as biological phenomenon and its effect on metabolism] Lek. wojsk., 1939, 33: 1-38.—Hoelzel, F. Central factors in hunger. Am. J. Physiol., 1927, 82: 665-71. ------ & Kleitman, N. Some conditions affecting subjective and objective manifesta- tions of hunger; hunger sensation giving rise to a marked respiratory change. Arch. Int. M., 1927, 39: 710-40.— Kasahara, M., Kasahara, T., & Horie, M. Studien iiber den Vitamin C-Gehalt im Liquor cerebrospinalis; Untersuchungen iiber den Vitamin C-Gehalt im Liquor bei Hungerversuchen. Zschr. ges. Neur. Psychiat., 1937-38, 160: 528.—Kassil, G. N., Plotitsyna, T. G., & Tolmasskaia, E. S. [Effect of hunger on the hemato-encephalic barrier] In Hematoentsef. barier (Stern. L. S. [et al.]) Moskva, 1935, 519-31.—Klein, W. Respirations- versuche an Hungerhunden mit und ohne Schilddruse. Bio- chem. Zschr., 1926, 168: 187-91.—Kojima, K. Das Eisen in normalen und pathologischen Geweben und seine biologische Bedeutung; Verteilung des Eisens in verschiedenen Organen von Kaninchen im Hungerzustande. Nagoya J. M. Sc, 1931, 5: 94-102.—Konishi, N. Ueber den Einfluss des Hungers auf Hamazakis Cr-saurefeste Granula. Okayama igakkai zasshi, 1937, 49: 236; 519.—Kratinov. A. G. IPhysiology of hunger action of the digestive apparatus] J. eksp. biol., 1929, 11: 57-63. ------& Kratinov, P. N. Beitrage zur Physiologie der Hungertatigkeit des Verdauungsapparates; weitere Ergebnisse iiber den Zustand der Hungerbewegungen des Magens bei parathyreopriver Tetanie. Zschr. ges. exp. Med., 1927, 57: 337-45.—Kratinov, P. N. Beitrage zur Physiologie der Hunger- tatigkeit des Verdauungsapparates; iiber den Einfluss des Cholins auf die Hungerbewegungen des Kropfes bei Hhhnern- Ibid., 1929, 64: 413-6.—Krijgsman, B. J. Der Blutzucker- spiegel wahrend des Hungerns; zugleich ein Beitrag zur Me- thodik der Blutzuckerbestimmung mit dem Pulfrich-Paoto- meter. Arch, neerl. physiol., 1933, 18: 173-92.—Lalich, J., HUNGER 901 HUNGER Meek, W. J., & Herrin, R. C. Reflex pathways concerned in inhibition of hunger contractions by intestinal distention. Am. J. Physiol., 1936, 115: 410-4.—Lawson, H. The physiology of hunger and thirst. Kentucky M. J., 1938, 36: 432-5.—Main. R. ;J. Variations in alveolar carbon dioxide in man during hunger. Am. J. Physiol., 1937, 119: 7-12.—Malysheva, L. A. |Efffcct of hunger on the condition of immunity] J. eksp. biol., 1930, 14: 34-6.—Mangold, E. Schilddruse und pramortale StickstofTsteigerung beim Hungertier. Biochem. Zschr., 1926, 168r 178-86.—Manville, I. A., & Chuinard, E. G. Studies on the gastric hunger mechanism. Am. J. Digest. Dis., 1934-35, 1: 6?8-93.—Manville, I. A., & Munroe, W. R. Studies on the gasttic hunger mechanism; the inhibitory effect of dextrose solutions. Ibid., 1937-38, 4: 561-75.—Maranon, G. La r^gularisation hormonale de la faim. Progr. mid., Par., 1938, pt. 2, 1253-7.—Monauni, J. Studien iiber die objektiven Faktoren des Hungers und des Sattseins. Wien. Arch. inn. Medl, 1938, 32: 159; 215.—Mulinos, M. G. The gastric hunger mechanism; the effect of diet. Proc. Soc. Exp. Biol., N. Y., 1930-31, 28: 520-3. ------ The influence of experimental alterations in blood sugar concentration on the gastric hunger contractions. Am. J. Physiol., 1933, 104: 371-8.—Nakamura. G. Clinical studies in types of gastric hunger movement. Jap. J. Gastroenter., 1930, 2: 115-29, pl.—Nekludow, W. N., & Ne'kludowa, E. A. Das morphologische Blutbild beim Hungern undenteralerSensibilisierungundAnaphvlaxie. Virchows Arch., 1931, 280: 374-84.—Nishi«ishi, S., Ishikawa, S. [et all Bei- trage zum Hungerstudium. J. Orient. M., Dairen, 1930, 13: 59-62.—Noltenius, F., & Hartmann, H. Das Verhalten der Korperfunktionen im Hungerzustande. Deut. med. Wschr., 1936, 62: 644-7.—Norpoth, L. Die Bedeutung des Magens fiir die Entstehung der Hungerempfindung. Arch. Ver- dauungskr., 1933, 54: 129-45.—Palladin, A., & Epelbaum, S. Ueber den Einfluss von Hungern auf den Kreatingehalt in Muskeln und auf die Kreatin- und Kreatininausscheidung bei Katzen. Biochem. Zschr., 1929, 204: 150-04.—Parturier, G., & Legrain, C. Semeiologie h4pato-biliaire de la faim. Rev. mid. cbir. mal. foie, 1936, 11: 466-83.—Peczenik, O. Vergleichende Untersuchungen iiber Harnproteasen; die proteolytische Wir- kung des Harnes im protrahierten Hunger und bei experimentell erhohtem Eiweissabbau. Fermentforschung, 1926-27, 9: 166-91.—Pletnev, A. Sur la faim, l'app6tit et ie rassasiement; r6flexe alimentaire et conduite. Bull. biol. mid. exp. URSS, 1939, 8: 244-7.—Popov, N. A., & Bobyleva. E. A. [Effect of various glands of internal secretion on hunger in piseons] Tr. Inst. eksp. vet. med., Moskva, 1930, 7: 13-6.—Ri, K. The acetaldehyde formation in the liver of dogs in a condition of hunger. J. Biochem., Tokyo, 1940, 31: 222.—Rogers, F. T., & Martin, C. L. X-ray observations of hunger contractions in man. Am. J. Physiol., 1926, 76: 349-53.—Romel, E. L. ^Effect of hunger on oxidation processes in animal tissues] J. eksp. biol., 1930, 14: 61-7.—Rossi, F., & Villani, L. Modi- ficazioni nei connettivo della tonaca propria deH'intestino di animali digiunanti. Ricer. morf., 1934, 14: 545-603, 3 pl.— Ruska, H., & Oestreicher, T. Der Stoffwechsel des isolierten Fcttgewebes; Normalgewebe und Gewebe im Verlauf des Hungers. Arch. exp. Path., Berl., 1934-35, 177: 42-52.— Schazillo, B. A., &Konstantinowskaja,D. C. Ueber den Einfluss des experimentellen Hungerns auf den K- und Ca-Ionengehalt im Blutserum. Biochem. Zschr., 1928, 201: 318-22.—Selye, H. [Hyperglycemia in hunger] Biull. eksp. biol. med., 1939, 8: 339-44.—Shelagurov, A., & Egorov, K. lEffect of privation and intake of liquids on metabolism in hunger] J. physiol. USSR, 1938, 23: 136-40.—Slotopolsky, B. Das Verhalten des Blutzuckers im Hunger. KUn. Wschr., 1932, 11: 984-8 — Stefko, W. H. Der Einfluss des Hungerns auf Blut und blutbildende Organe. Virchows Arch., 1923, 247: 86-117. -----Beitrag zur Kenntnis der Veranderungen des Pankreas bei Menschen und Affen beim Hungern. Krankheitsforschung, 1928, 6: 442-57.—Suzuki, M. Der Einfluss des Hungerns auf Blut und blutbildende Organe des Meerschweinchens, insbe- sondere uber die Granulopoese, welche in dem lymphatischen Apparate auftritt. Sc. Rep. Inst. Infect. Dis., Tokyo, 1925, 4: 259-67, pl.—Templeton, R. D., & Johnson, V. Further obser- vations on the nature of hunger contractions in man. Am. J. Physiol., 1929, 88: 173-6.—Trusevich, B. I. [Beitriige zur Untersuchung der Magensekretion beim Hungern] J. physiol. USSR, 1934, 17: 249-52.—Walinski, F. Die Einwirkung des Hungers auf die Alkalireserve im menschlichen Blut. Khn. Wschr., 1926, 5: 600-2.—Wangensteen, O. H., & Carlson, H. A. Hunger sensations in a patient after total gastrectomy. Proc. Soc. Exp. Biol., N. Y., 1930-31, 28: 545-7.—Weicksel. Stoff- wechsel im Hunger. Deut. med. Wschr., 1926, 52: 1839. Also Khn. Wschr., 1926, 5: 2236.—Wertenberger, G. E. The effect of experimental hyperthyroidism on hunger contractions in the bull-frog. Am. J. Physiol., 1933, 104: 624-7.—Wert- heimer, E. Stoffwechselregulationen;Regulationen im Hunger stoffwechsel; die Abhangigkeit der Muskelglykogendepots vom Nervensystem. Arch. ges. Physiol., 1926-27, 215: 779-95 — Wetzel, R., Wollschitt, H. let al.] Ueber den Eiweiss-, Fett- und Kohlehydratstoffweehsel der weissen Ratte; der Einfluss des Hungers. Arch. exp. Path., Berl., 1936, 181: 703-38 — Yamamoto, S. Studien iiber die Veranderungen des Gewebs- eiweisses und dessen kolloid-osmotische Drucks unter ver- schiedenen Bedingungen; Gewebseiweiss und dessen kolloid- osmotischer Druck im Hunger. Tohoku J. Exp. M., 196H, ii: 354-68.—Yasaki, S., & Mandai, H. Electrocardiographic observation of hunger. Acta Schol&e med. Umv. Kioto, 1931, 14- 127-9 —Zubenko, P. [Effect of hunger on the functions of 129-4irV°US Sytem In d°gSl DniPr°Petr- med. J., 1930, 9: ---- Psychology. Groeneveld, C. *Einfluss des Hungers auf die Psyche. 26p. 21^cm. Bonn, 1937. _ Hamilton, E. L. *The effect of delayed incentive on the hunger drive in the white rat [Columbia Univ.] p. 137-207. 8? Worcester, Mass., 1929. c Bash, K. W- An investigation into a possible organic basis for the hunger drive. J. Comp. Psychol., 1939, 28: 109-34 Pu-j "" ,o-, ™ Contribution to a theory of the hunger drive! Ibid., 137-60—Bayer, E. Beitrage zur Zweikomponenten- Auei0rle1,?™ Hungers. Zschr. Psychol. Physiol. Sinnesorg., 1. Abt., 1929, 112: 1-54.—Beck, G. Neue Beitrage zur Zwei- komponententheone des Hungers. Ibid., 1930 118- 283- 349—Bousvield, W. A., & Elliott, M. H. The experimental control of the hunger-drive. J. Gen. Psychol., 1936, 15: 327- 34.—Bousfield, W. A., & Sherif, M. Hunger as a factor in learning. Am. J. Psychol., 1932, 44: 552-4.—Bousfield, W. A., & Spear, E. Influence of hunger on the pecking responses of chickens. Ibid., 1935, 47: 482-4.—Cannon, W. B. Hunger and thirst. In Handb. Gen. Exp. Psvchol. (Murchison C 1 Worcester, 1934, 247-63.—Cowles, J. f. Food versus no food on the pre-delay trial of delayed response. J. Comp. Psychol 1941, 32: 153-64.—Elliott, M. H. The effect of hunger on variability of performance. Am. J. Psychol., 1934, 46: 107- 12.—Finan, J. L. Quantitative studies in motivation; strength of conditioning in rats under varying degrees of hunger. J Comp. Psychol., 1940, 29: 119-34.— Fletcher, F. M. Effects of quantitative variation of food-incentive on the performance of physica] work by chimpanzees. Comp. Psychol. Monogr. 1940, 16: No. 3, 1-46— Gantt, W. H. Relation of uncondi- tioned and conditioned reflex; effect of prolongation of the work period from the usual one hour to a period of 10 to 20 hours. J. Gen. Psychol., 1940, 23: 377-85.—Hamilton, E. L. The effect of delayed incentive on the hunger drive in the white rat. Genet. Psychol. Monogr., 1929, 5: 133-207.—Katz, D. Some fundamental laws of the psychology of needs: hunger. Character & Personality, 1934-35, 3: 312-20. ----— Zur Grundlegung einer Bediirfnispsychologie. Acta psychol., Hague, 1935, 1: 119-28.—Kostenetskaia, N. A. [Cortical component of the unconditioned alimentary reaction and the activity of the cortical alimentary center] Biull. eksp. biol. med., 1940, 10: 90-2.—Levy, D. M. Primary effect hunger. Am. J. Psychiat., 1937-38, 94: 643-52.—Margolin, S. E., & Bunch, M. E. The relationship between age and the strength of hunger motivation. Comp. Psychol. Monogr., 1940, 16: No. 4, 1-34.—Morgan, C. T., & Morgan, J. D. Studies in hunger; the effects of insulin upon the rat's rate of eating. J. Genet. Psychol., 1940, 56: 137-47.—Noltenius, F. Psycho- physiologische Beobachtungen iiber den Einfluss des Hungerns und seine therapeutische Bedeutung. Arch. Verdauungskr., 1931, 49: 43-54.—Nowlis, V. The relation of degree of hunger to competitive interaction in chimpanzee. J. Comp. Psychol., 1941, 32: 91-115.—Prentice, E. P. The effect of want on the human mind. In his Hunger & Hist., N. Y., 1939, 137-47 — Rosenthal, I. S. (The effect of hunger on conditioned reflexes] Arch. biol. nauk, 1922, 21: 151-8.—Seward, G. H. Studies on the reproductive activities of the guinea pig; the role of hunger in filial behavior. J. Comp. Psychol., 1940, 29: 25-41.— Tigerstedt, C. Beitrag zur Kenntnis des Einflusses des Hun- gerns auf die Fahigkeit eine mechanische Prazisionsarbeit auszufiihren. Bull. Battle Creek Sanit., 1929, 24: 285-8.— Warden, C. J., & Jackson, T. A. A preliminary study of the hunger drive in the rhesus monkey. J. Genet. Psychol., 1935, 46: 126-38.—Wulff Rasmussen, E. The shock method as a measure of hunger and of the intensity of a conflict. Acta psychol., Hague, 1940, 5: 63-78.—Young, P. T. Food appetites in relation to activity and the rate of learning. Psychol. Bull., 1941, 38: 534. HUNGERBUEHLER, Emil, 1903- *Un- tersuchungen von Rinderstallungen im Sinne der praktischen Stallkontrolle (ein Beitrag zur Frage der Zusammenhange zwischen Stall und Krank- heit) [Zurich] 47p. pl. map. 9 ch. 8? Wald, W. Hess, 1935. HUNGERBUEHLER, Ruth, 1911- *Ueber zwei Falle von Irissarkom die durch eine Iridektomie entfernt werden konnten. 15p. 8? Tub., Bolzle, 1936. HUNGER cure. See Fasting, Therapeutic use. HUNGERLAND, Alarich Heinz, 1904- *Der primare Pneumothorax auf der kontralatera- len Seite bei doppelt- und einseitiger Lungen- tuberkulose [Berlin] 23p. 8? Eisleben-Luther- stadt, E. Schneider, 1935. HINGERLAM) 902 HI NT HINGERLAND, Heinz, 1905- *Vorkom- men des Acet\ h holin im Kaltbliiter [Freiburg] Sp. S? Quakenbruck, C. Trute, 1932. HUNGER strike. Rousset. S., Daumezon. G., & Masson, J. Greve de la faim poursuivie depuis 8 ans par un revendicateur pur. Ann. mid. psychol., Par., 1938, 96: pt 2, 76-88. HINGRECKER [Ernest] Adolf, 1SS4 *Z\vei Beitrage zur Kasuistik der Polyeythamie mit Milztumor. 26p. 8°. Konigsb. [n. pub.] 1914. HUNG Te Chang, Stephen. ^Studies on rigor mortis of the heart [Univ. Chicago] 30p. 8? Chicago, 111. [n. pub.] 1936. HINKE, Heinrich, 1902- Zagrozenie powietrzne i obrona przeciwlotnicza [transl. from German by A. Wojtyga] 190p. S? Warszawa, Liga obr. pow., 1934. HUNKELER, Martin. *Untersuchungen uber die Darmbakterienflora der Honigbiene nebst Bemerkungen zur Phvsiologie des Bienendarmes [Zurich] 83p. 2 tab. 8? Willisau [n. pub.] 1925. HUNNER'S ulcer. See under Bladder. HUNNIUS, Elsbeth, 1911- ^Statistische Untersuchungen iiber die haufigslen Zahn- und Mundkrankheiten nach dem Material einer zahnarztlichen Praxis [Munster] 63p. 21cm. Werne a. d. Lippe, F. Grube, 1935. Hl'NOLD, Emil, 1909- * Ueber das Verhalten der Korpertemperaturen nach Opera- tionen in ortlicher Betiiubung. 28p. X? Mail)., II. Friedrich, 1935. HUNOLD, Helmut, 1911- *Ueber das Verhalten des Blutzuckerspiegels nach Neben- nierenrindeninjekt ion bei Diabetikern und Infek- tionskranken [Munchen] 15p. 21cm. Speyer, Pilger, 1938. HUNOLD, Kurt, 1906- *Kapillarunter- snclningen bei Kindern mit Entwicklungs- Storungen am Kiefer [Frankfurt a. M.] 19p. 8? [Berl., H. Pusch & Co.] 1928. HUNSCHEIDT, Herbert, 1903- *Wie sind die Metastasen der Mischgeschwiilste des Hodens im Vergleich zu den primaren Geschwul- stcn gehaut? (mit besonderer Berucksichtigung des Chorionepithelioms) 49p. 8? Bonn, L. Xeuendorff, 1928. HI NSCHER, Helen A. Suggested questions for state board examination for nurses; from the report of the Professional Education Section. 16p. 8? Chic, Am. Diet. Ass., 1934. HUNSICKER, William C, 1873-1939. Wells. G. H. Obituarv. Hahneman. Month., 1939, 74: 117-9. HUNSTANTON, Engl. Convalescent Home. Annual report. Hunstanton, 12.-13., 1883-84; 16.-18., 1887-89; 20., 1891; 24.-2.5., 1895-96. HUNSTEIN, Walter, 1908- *Dentaler Focus und Hautkrankheiten [Tubingen] 22p. 1 1. 8? Erfurt, A. Oesterle [1931] HINT. Arthur Ellsworth. Sim IVabodv. J. K.. & Hunt, A. E. Biology and human welfare. o»5p. 8t X. Y., 1924. HINT, Caroline L. The life of Ellen H. Kichards. xiv p. 328p. pl. portr. 8? Bost., Whitcomb & Barrows, 1912. ----Good proportions in the diet. 24p. 8? Wash., Gov. Print. Off., 1923. Forms No. 1313, Farmer's Bull. HINT. De Forest. Homeopathic treatment of diphtheria. 102p. 16° Grand Rapids, Mich., Eaton, Lyon A; co., 1SS0. HINT, Donald G., & PHILLIPS, John F. Heywood & Massey's Lunacy practice. 6. ed. xl\ii, tiNTp. 25''cm. Lond., Stevens tv sons ltd 1939. HUNT, Edward J. A., 1909- , & BECK, Waller. *Methode zur Prufung wehencnrgcnder Suhstanzen an der Scheide des Kaninchens [Heidelberg] p.284-90. 23'^cin. Wurzb., H. Stiirtz, 1938. Also Arch. Gyn., Berl., 1938, 167: HUNT, Elizabeth. Diseases affecting the vulva, xiii, 215p. illust. 18 col. pl. 25'.cm. Lond., H. Kimpton, 1940. HUNT, Frazier, 1885- The little doc; the story of Allan Roy Dafoe, physician to the quintuplets, xii, 302p. portr. 21cm. X. Y., Simon & Schuster [1939] HUNT, George Herbert, 1884-1925. H.. A. F. Obituary. Guy's Hosp. (biz., bond., 1920, 40: 53-5. Also Guv's Hosp. Rep., Lond., 192(i. 7(1: 127 -31, portr. Also Lancet, Lond., 1920, 1: 205. T.. W. H. Obituarv. Brit. M. J., 1926, 1: 170. For portrait, photograph, see Collection in Library. HUNT, Harold Capper, & MACLEOD, Neil. A retired habitation; a history of the Betreat, York (Mental Hospital) xvi, 144p. pl. portr. 8? Lond., H. K. Lewis & co., 1932. HUNT, Harold Lyons, 1882- Plastic surgery of the head, face and neck, xiv [17]- 404p. 10 pl. 8? Phila,, Lea & Febiger, 1926. See also [Biography] Alcd. Rec, N. V., 193."\ 141: 110. HUNT, H. F. (jt auth.) Sec Winn, D. S. M., k Hunt, H. F. First aid in air raids. 55p. 18cm. Lond., 1941. HUNT, Howard Beeman, 1902- Princi- ples of radiotherapy, p.326-91. 25cm. N. Y., 1). Appleton-Centurv co., 1940. In Ther. Int. Dis. (Blumer, (.!. [et al.]) v.l. HUNT, James Ramsay, 1874-1937. Collected papers describing various neurological syndromes and clinical types [v. p.] illust. 8° N. Y. [n. pub.] 1907-32. Sec also Cobb, S., Draper, (i., 4p. 8. Bait- Williams & Wilkins co., 1928. HUNTER, James Wilson, jr, 1878-194 / Eley C W. [Obituary] Am. J. Boentg., 1940.44 . HUNTER, John, 1728-93. Treatise on the venereal disease; with copious additions by Dr Philip Ricord. 2. ed. xvi, 552p. 8? Phila., Blanchard & Lea, 1859. See Holmes, T. Introductory address delivered at St George s Hospital, October 2, 1893, on the centenary of John Hunters death. 80p. 8? Lond., 1893. Also Remark* on presentation of death mask of John Hunter to the St Louis Medical Society, by William Washington Graves M D remarks by the president, Francis Reder, M. D. John Hunter ! 1728-1893) the man and his spirit, by Robert Schlueter. M. D. I&c] [8]p. 8? [S. Louis, 1932] Also Wengel, F. "Darstellung der Odontologie Hunters im Vergleich zur heutigen [Wiirzbur<*l 21 p. 8? Ochsenf., 1934. See also Bibliography. Med. Classics, 1939-40, 4: 403-18 — [Biography] In Cardiac Classics (Willius, F. A.) S. Louis, 1941, 204-7, portr. Also Cat. Portr. R. Coll. Surgeons, Lond., 1930, portr. opp. 34. Also J. R. Army M. Corps, 1937, 68: 1 15-8. Also in Leadership in medicine (Sir B. G. A. Moynihan) London, 1933, 31-5. Also Med. Classics, 1939-40, 4: 401-3.— Castro Villagrana, J. John Hunter. In his Entre cirujan. & hosp., Mix., 1940,49-53.—Clendening.L. Science and surgery- John Hunter. In Behind the Doctor (Clendening, L.) N. Y., 1933, 249-57.—Fagge, C. H. The Hunterian oration on John Hunter to John Hilton. Guv's Hosp. Rep., Lond., 1936, S6: 249-68, 5 portr.—Finney, J. M. T. The influence of John Hunter upon early American surgery. Lancet, Lond., 1927, 1: 440; 469.—Gask. G. E. John Hunter in the campaign in Portugal, 1702-30. Brit. J. Surg., 1936-37, 24: 640-68.— Gilcreest, E. L. John Hunter: the founder of scientific surgerv. In Lectures Hist. Med., 1926-32, Phila., 1933, 339-55. Also Proc. Mayo Clin., 1929, 4: 1. Also Surg. Clin. N. America, 1928, 8: 1273-87. Also Tr. West. Surg. Ass. (1928) 1929, 38: 109-27, portr. Also repr.—Guthrie, D. John Hunter; surgeon and naturalist. Edinburgh M. J., 1942, 49: 119- 35.—Guttmacher, M. S. John Hunter, his enemies and his friends. Bull. Johns Hopkins Hosp., 1929, 45: 15-39.— Handley. R. S. John Hunter. Middlesex Hosp. J., 1933, 210: 153-65, portr. ------ Makers of John Hunter. Brit. M. J., 1939, 1: 313-7. Also Lancet, Lond., 1939, 1: 369-75, pl — Herve, G. John Hunter et ses travaux de g6n6tique. Bull. Soc. fr. hist, mid., 1930, 24: 228-39.—Hobday, F. The debt veterinary science owes to John Hunter. Vet. Rec, Lond., 1934, 14: 471-4. ■---— John Hunter, pioneer of veterinary science. Tr. Hunterian Soc, Lond., 1937-38, 2: 89-100. Also Vet. Rec, Lond., 1938, 50: 1687-92.—Home, E. A short account [of the life of the late John Hunter] (first Ameri- can ed. 1796) In Cardiac Classics (Willius, F. A.) S. Louis, 1941, 269-75, facsim.—Horder, L. The Hunt«rian tradi- tion. Tr. Hunterian Soc, Lond., 1936-37, 1: Ik!-78.------ Hunter the great researcher. Lancet, Lond., 1937, 1: 587-9.— Howat, R. K. Wrhen was John Hunter born? Ibid., 351.— Howell, W. B. A meeting which never took place! a play in half an act. Ann. M. Hist., 1936, 8: 541-6.—Hunterian dinner ;it the College of Surgeons. Brit. M. J., 1939, 1: 401.—Jacobs, W. H. John Hunter and occlusion. Internat. J. Orthodont., 1937, 23: 807-9. Also repr.—John Hunter, Army surgeon. Lecture at Royal College of Surgeons. Brit. M. J., 1937, 1: 401.—John Hunter as a military surgeon. Lancet, Lond., 1937, 1: 457.—John Hunter as a pioneer of veterinary science. Nature, Lond., 1938, 141: 521.—John Hunter's, 1728-1793, account of self inoculation with supposed gonorrheal pus. Urol. Cut. Rev., 1941, 45: 797.—John Hunter's remains; the removal from St Martin's to the Abbey. Brit. M. J., 1936, 2: 817.—Keith, Sir A. A discourse on the portraits and per- sonality of John Hunter. Ibid., 1928, 1: 205-9. —---- The bicentenary of John Hunter. Nature, Lond., 1928, 121: 210-2. ------ John Hunter (1728-93) experimental surgerv. In Brit. Masters of Med. (Power, D'A.) Bait., 1936, 42-51. [ports.]—Koch, C. R. E. [Biography] In his Hist. Dent. Surg., Chic, 1909, 1: 65-75, portr.—Leadingham, R. S. [Biography] Med. J. k Rec. N. Y., 1926, 123: 652-5- Meyer, A. W. Mr John Hunter on generation. California West. M., 1935, 43: 358-63.—Moynihan, Sir B. Hunter's ideal and Lister's practice. Brit. M. J., 1927, 1: 313-9. Also Lancet, Lond., 1927, 1: 373-9.— Olmsted, J. M. D. A student's notes on John Hunter's course of lectures of 1775. Bull. Hist. M., Bait., 1939, 7: 996-1003.—Peachey, G. C. The homes of the Hunters. Lancet, Lond., 1928, 1: 360-7.—Power, D'A. John Hunter; the experimental surgeon. In his Mirror for Surgeons, Bost., 1939, 112-8.—Rathbun, N. P. Biography. Am. J. Surg.. 1937, 37: 138-43.—Robinson. V. [Biography] Med. Life, N. Y., 1929, 36: 119-36, portr.—Russell, K. F. John Hunter and his masterpiece. Austral. N. Zealand J. Surg., 1938-39, 8: 335-9.—Ryle, J. A. A note on John Hunter's •ardiac infarct. Lancet, Lond., 1928, 1: 332-4.—Schlueter, ft. E. [Biography] In: Remarks on presentation of death mask of John Hunter to the St Louis Medical Society, St Louis, 1932.—Sierra, L. [Biography] Bol. Soc. cir. Chile, 1928, 6: 15-62 portr.—Sprigge, Sir S. Grand curiosity as examplified in the life of John Hunter. Lancet, Lond., 1928, 2: 739-41.— T?Met unveiled at Bath. Med. Press & Circ, Dubl., 1930, 192: 490-1.—Viets, H. R. The destruction of the Hunter manuscripts; was it an act of piety? Bull. Johns Hopkins Hosp 1930 46: 145-8.—Wallace, C. The Hunterian oration, Brit. M. J., 1934, 1: 269-73. >04 HUNTER'S CANAL HUNTER For portrait, see Guv's Hosp. Rep., Lond., 1930, 86: No. 3, front. Also Med. Classics, 1939-40, 4: No. 5, front. Also Surg. Gyn. Obst., 1937, 65: front. HUNTER, John Bowman. Sec Carless. Albert, Rose, William [et al.] Rose and Carless' manual of surgerv. 14. ed. M87p. 8? Lond., 1933. Also 15. ed. I.'<30p. 8° Bait., 1937. HUNTER, Joseph, 1869-1935. Obituary. Brit. M. J., 1935, 2: 235. HUNTER, Monica. See Wilson, G., & Hunter, M. The study of African society. 21p. 25cm. Livingston, 1939. HUNTER, Richard Henry. A short history of anatomy. 51p. 16? Lond., J. Bale sons & Danielsson, 1925. Also 2. ed. 86p. 12? 1931. ---- Aids to embryology. 2. ed. viii, 172p. illust. 16? Lond., Bailliere, Tindall & Cox, 1934. Also 3. ed. viii, 178p. illust. 16? 1938. Abo editor of Ulster (The) medical journal. Belfast, v.l, 1932- HUNTER, Thomas Charles, 1876-1941. Greig, G. M. Obituary. Brit. M. J., 1941, 2: 830. HUNTER, Walter, 1850-1941. Obituary. Glasgow M. J., 1941, 135: 159. HUNTER, Walter Samuel, 1889- Gen- eral psychology. xiii, 351p. illust. 20cm. [Chic] Univ. Chicago press [1919] ---- Learning. IV: Experimental studies of learning, p.497-570. 8? Worcester, 1934. In Handb. Gen. F.xp. Psychol. tMuiehisun. ('.) Also editor of Comparative psychology monographs. Bait., v.l, 1923- HUNTER, Wiles Robert, 1874- See Chicago. City Homes Association. Tenement condi- tions in Chicago; report by the investigating committee of the City Homes Association. 208p. 8? Chic, 1901. HUNTER, William, 1718-83. [Biography] Cut. Portr. R. Coll. Surgeons, Lond., 1930, 37, portr. opp. 38.—Olmsted, J. M. D. The Hunter manuscript in the Sutro collection; a correction. Bull. Hist. M., 1940 8: 291-3.— Plarr, V. G. The Hunter-Baillie collection. Brit. M.J., 1926,2:120.—Schumann, E. A. William Hunter lecturing on obstetrics and infant care. Tr. Coll. Physicians Philadelphia, 1941, 9: 15-5-83. -William Hunter. Clin. M. & S., 1938, 45: 53, portr. HUNTER, William, 1729-77. Himmond, R. [Biography] Rhode Island M. J., 1941, 24: 199-201. Krumbhaar, E. B. Doctor William Hunter of Newport, Ann. Surg., Phila., 1935, 101: 506-28. Also in Surgery (Ravdin, L. S.) Phila., 1935, 506-28. HUNTER, William, 1861-1937. The Serbian epidemics of typhus and relapsing fever in 1915; their origin, course, and preventive measures employed for their arrest (an aetiological and preventive study based on records of British military sanitary mission to Serbia, 1915) p. 1. p.29-158. maps, charts. 24%cm. Lond., J. Bale, sons & Danielsson, 1920. See also Obituary. Proc. R. Soc. Edinburgh, 1936-37 57- 417. Also Lancet, Lond., 1937, 1: 235, portr. HUNTER, William M., 1819-89. Thorpe, B. L. William M. Hunter, early experimenter in continuous gum work and expert metallurgist. In his Biogr Pioneer Am. Dentists, Chic, 1909, 173-6, portr. HUNTER [and hunting] See also Sport; Tularemia. Lurkin, .1. Physiologie de la chasse. 176p. LW^em. Vervoz, Ocquier, 1938. Gausner, I. P.. A: Belitzer. A. V. [Gummatous disease affecting the water rat hunters in the Riazan government] Gig. epid., Moskva, 1928, 7: 53-9.—Pleasant, H., jr. Sports- men as research workers. Pennsylvania Health, 1941-42, 2: Xo. 11, 21.—Safety hints for hunters. Travelers Stand., 1940. HUNTERIAN society. See under London. HUMER'S canal. See under Thigh. HUNTINGDON County Hospital 11X59] An- nual reports. Huntingdon, 1879-85; 1896. HUNTINGTON, David Lowe, 1834-99, MEW W. M., & BILLINGS, J. S. On heating and ventilation. 93p. 8? Wash., Johns Hopkins Hosp., 1878. See also Keefer, F. R. Recollections of old medical officers: Lieutenant Colonel David Lowe Huntington. Mil Sureeon' Wash., 1928, 63: 565. ' HUNTINGTON, Ellsworth, 1876- World power and evolution. 287p. diagrs. 23^cm. Xew Haven, Yale Univ. press, 1919. ---- Civilization and climate. 2. ed. xliii, 333p. 8? New Haven, Yale Univ. press, 1922! ---- Tomorrow's children; the goal of eugenics, x, 139p. 21cm. N. Y., J. Wiley & sons, 1935. ---- Season of birth; its relation to human abilities, vii, 473p. illust. maps. tab. diagrs 8? N. Y., J. Wiley, 1938. ---- & CUSHING, Sumner W. Principles of human geography. 2. ed., rev. xiv, 430p. illust. diagrs. 23^cm. N. Y., J. Wiley & sons, 1922 HUNTINGTON, Elon Obed, 1870-1926. Obituary J. Am. M. Ass., Chicago, 1926, 87: 806. HUNTINGTON, George, 1850-1916. De Jong, R. N. George Huntington and his relationship to the earlier descriptions of chronic, hereditary chorea. Ann M Hist., 1937, 9: 201-10, 2 portr.—Stevenson. C. S. A biography of George Huntington, M. D. Bull. Johns Hopkins Hosp' 1934, 54: 53-76. HUNTINGTON, George Sumner, 1861-1927. Hrdlicka, A. Biographical memoir, p.245-84. 3 portr. 8? Wash., 1937. See also McClure, C. F. W. The life and work of George S Huntington. Bull. N. York Acad. M., 1928, 2. ser., 4: 250- 65.—Obituary. Am. J. Anat., 1927, 39: 35.5-77, portr. Also Boston M. & S. J., 1927, 196: 76. Also J.Am. M. Ass. 1927, 88: 261. Also Med. J. & Rec, N. Y., 1927, 125: 277. HUNTINGTON, Thomas Waterman, 1849- 1929. R., E. [Obituary] Tr. Am. Surg. Ass., 1929, 47: 400 — Rixford, E. Obituary. Ann. Surg., 1929, 90: 791.—Terry, W. I. Thomas Waterman Huntington. California West. M , 1938 48: 186, portr. HUNTINGTON'S chorea. See under Chorea. HUNTLY, Mabel F. See Eisenberg, Arthur Alexander, & Huntly, Mabel F. Principles of bacteriology, in 15 lessons. 5. ed. 322p. 8°. S. Louis, 1930. Also 6. ed. 378p. 8! S. Louis, 1935. HUNT'S syndrome. See Ear, Herpes zoster; Facial nerve, Paralysis. HUNWALD, Henrik. *Menstrualgift, Men- struationsstorung und Geisteskrankheit; ein Beitrag zur Prufung der Ansichten und Vorschlage Bernhard Aschners [Basel] 21p. 8? Berl., Biko, 1935. HUNWICKE, R. F. The essentials of bac- teriological technique. 108p. 8? Lond., Williams & Norgate, 1931. HUNZIKER, Hans, 1878-1941. Iselin. H. Zum Tode von Professor Hunziker. Praxis, Ben. 1912, 31: 38.—Maier, H. W. [Nekrologie] Schweiz. med. U schr., 1942, 72:132.—Reese. Nachruf fiirHansHunzi- ker in dei Medizinischen Gesellschaft. Ibid., 133. HUNZIKER, Otto Fred, 1873- Con- densed milk and milk powder, prepared for fac- tory, school and laboratory. 4. ed. 9 p. 1. 668p. 8? La Grange, 111., the Author, 1926. HUNZIKER, Rose. * Felix Platter als Arzt und Stadtarzt in Basel [Basel] 82p. 22^cm. Ziir., Gebr. Leeman & Co., 1939. HUNZIKER 905 HURET HUNZIKER, Rudolf. *Untersuchungen iiber das Auftreten des Rauschbrandes im Amt Frutigen und seine Beziehungen zum Kalkgehalt des Bodens. xv, 29p. 2 maps. 8? Bern, E. Sieber, 1926. HUNZIKER, Samuel. *Ueber gewerblichen Milzbrand [Basel] 44p. illust. 22^cm. Am- riswil, Grob & Ziircher, 1939. HUNZIKER, Walther. *Beziehungen zwischen Iso- und Auto-Haemagglutination im Austausch- versuch. 18p. 8? Basel [n. pub.] 1926. HUNZIKER-SCHILD, Heinrich. Der Kropf, eine Anpassung an jodarme Nahrung; apriori- stische Gedanken iiber Wesen und Verhiitung des Kropfes. 24p. 8? Bern, A. Francke, 1915. HUON pine oil. Grimwade, W. R. Huon pine oil and vanillin. Australas. J. Pharm., 1941, 22: 757.—Longden. H. Huon pine oil and ti-tree oil. Ibid., 593.—Sharland. W. Huon pine oil and ti-tree oil Ibid., 695. HUOT, Louis, & VOIVENEL, P. La psy- chologie du soldat. xvi, 165p. 19cm. Par., La Renaissance du Livre [1918] HUPE, Franz, 1901- *Die operative Behandlung der Wanderleber [Leipzig] 18p. 8? [Zeulenroda, A. Oberreuter] 1929. HUPP, Frank Le Hayne, 1865-1929. Elliott, E. [Biography] Tr. Am. Surg. Ass., 1932, 50: 540.— Obituary. P. verb. Congr. Soc. internat. chir., 1932, 9. Congr., 1: 116-8. HUPP, Herbert, 1911- *Lassen sich an Gebisseu von Schulkindern Einflusse von Ernah- rung (Brot, Gemiise, Milch) und Zahnpflege auf Entstehung und Ausbreitung der Karies fest- stellen? [Berlin] 35p. 23cm. Charlottenb., K. & 11. Hoffmann, 1938. HUPPENBAUER, Carl. Buschdoktor. 257p. map. 8? Tub., Rainer Wunderlich Verl. [1937] See also Wald, R. Deutsche Aerzte, wie sie denken und dichten; auch eine Literaturegeschichte; Carl Huppenbauer. Zschr. iirztl. Fortbild., 1939, 36: 183-5, portr. HUPPERT, Marianne, 1905- *Beobach- tungen am Magen- und Darmkanal des Frosches bei Verfutterung oder Injektion von Farbstoffen. p.602-14. 8? [Freib. i. B., n. pub.] 1928. Also Zschr. Zellforsch., 1925-26, 3: HUPPERTZ [Werner] Josef, 1902- *Ueber Selbstverstummelungen an den Geni- talien und ihre ps'ychischen Ursachen. 38p. 8? [Bonn, n. pub.] 1926. HUPPERZ, Wilhelm, 1904- *Neo-Elden- tog. Hp. 8? Wurzb., K. Triltsch, 1930. HURD, Charles De Witt, 1897- Open- chain nitrogen compounds, p.609-719. 23J4cm. X. Y., J. Wiley & sons, 1938. In Organic chem. (Gilman, H.) v.l. HURD, Henry Mills, 1843-1927. Ames, J. S., & Harlan, H. D. Dedication of the Henry M. Hurd Memorial Hall, the Osier medical clinic and the Halsted surgical clinic. Bull. Johns Hopkins Hosp., 1933, 52: 87-113.— Cullen, T. S. Henry Mills Hurd, first superintendent of Johns Hopkins Hospital. Johns Hopkins Alumni Mag., 1928, 227-48.—Obituary. Bull. Johns Hopkins Hosp., 1927, 41: 155, portr. Also J. Am. M. Ass., 1927, 89: 389. Also Med. J. & Rec, N. Y., 1927, 126: 183. For portrait, see in Book of Portraits (Ulmann, D.) Bait., 1922. HURD-MEAD, Kate Campbell. See Mead, Kate Campbell Hurd. HURDON, Elizabeth, 1869-1941. Chadburn, M. M. Obituary. Lancet, Lond., 1941, 1: 265.—Obituary. Brit. M. J., 1941, 1: 299. Also J. Am. M. Ass., 1941, 116: 1596. Also Lancet, Lond., 1941, 1: 199, portr. HURET, Gabriel Aime Louis, 1904- *L'angor aigu coronarien febrile; forme angineuse de 1'occlusion coronarienne aigue. lllp. 8? Par., Masson & cie, 1931. I See also Lian, Camille Blondel A tat „i i t • . noitrine. 429p. 8? Par, 1932 [ ] LanSine de HUREZ, Andre Lucien, 1905- *Con tnbution a l'etude clinique et therapeutique des maladies typhoides de I'enfance. 209d 8° Par., Louis Arnette, 1935. . , ~ Le traitement des broncho-pneumonies mfantiles. 60p. 23^cm. Par., J. B. Bailliere & nls, 1937. HUREZ, Marcel Andre, 1899- Con- tribution k l'etude du traitement de la tuberculose pulmonaire par un compose sero-medicamenteux (denomme: Compose L. T.) 73p 8° Par A. Legrand, 1927. HURIAU, Pierre Henri Gabriel, 1908- Les cavernes pulmonaires geantes par tuber- culose ulcero-fibreuse stationnaire. 122p 8° Par., Jouve & cie, 1935. HURIEZ, Claude. ocSee ?arriT^e, G & Huriez, C. Le sang des hypertendus. Sop. 8? Par., 1936. HURLER'S syndrome. See under Chondro-osteodystrophy. HURLIN, Ralph Gibney, 1888- Salaries in medical social work in 1937. 34p. incl. form. 23cm. N. Y., Russell Sage foundation, 1938. HURLOCK, Elizabeth Bergner, 1898- Modern ways with babies; physical and mental development, viii, 347p. illust. pl. 8? Phila., J. B. Lippincott co. [1937] HURM, Anna, 1910- *Abnorme Narben- bildungen nach Schonheits-Operationen [Kiel] 22p. 8? Sigmaringen, M. Uehnner, 1933-34. HUROWITZ, Jacob, 1909- *Ueber einen ungewohnlichen Fall von Hydromerencephalie. 34p. 8? Ziir., O. Fussli, 1936. Also Schweiz. Arch. Neur. Psychiat., 1936, 38: HURPY, Fernand, 1900- *Le citrate de soude dans le traitement des varices; indications, technique, resultats cliniques. 56p. 8? Par., A. Legrand, 1926. HURRICANE. See also Disaster. Brooks, C. F. Hurricanes into New England; meteorology of the storm of September 21, 1938. Annual Rep. Smithsori. Inst. (1939) 1940, 241-51.—Maloney, J. W. Hurricane- proofing the Keys. Red Cross Courier, 193G, 15: No. 8, 3-5. ------The Red Cross mops up in New England. Ibid., 1938-39, 18: No. 8, 17-20.—Morrow, T. L., & Lowry, E. F. Relief work following the Belize hurricane. U. S. Nav. M. Bull., 1932, 30: 297-302, pl—Relief progress in 2 hurricane areas; efficacy of Red Cross tested in twin disasters. Red Cross Courier, 1928, 7: No. 20, 22-8.—Scout cooperation in the last hurricane. Ibid., 1938-39, 18: No. 8, 12-4.—Sumner, II. C. North Atlantic tropical disturbances of 1941. Month. Weather Rev., WTash., 1941, 69: 363.—Weil, J. Tracking hurricanes. Johns Hopkins Alumni Mag., 1940, 27: 109-13. HURRY, Jamieson Boyd, 1857-1930. Imho- tep, the vizier and physician of King Zoser and afterwards the Egyptian god of medicine, xvi, 118p. 17 pl. 8? Lond., Oxford Univ. press, 1926. Also xvi, 21 lp. 16 pl. 8? 1928. See also Obituary. S. Barth. Hosp. J., Lond., 1929-30, 37: 94, portr. HURST [Hertz] Sir Arthur [Frederick] 1879- The time has come ... the Harveian oration delivered before the Royal College of Physicians of London on St Luke's Day, 1937. 42p. 19cm. Lond., Headley bros [1938] ---- Medical diseases of war. viii, 327p. illust. 4 pl. diagr. 22cm. Bait., Williams & Wilkins co., 1940. Also another ed. viii, 427p. illust. 8 pl. 22cm. Lond., E. Arnold & co. [1941] Previous ed. (1916, 1918) published under title: Medical diseases of the war. HIRST 900 HURWKZ Gastric and 8? Lond. 1870- Pharmacy apprenticeship 3v. in 1. illust. portr. [Toronto] Univ. Toronto See also B., R. C. Arthur F. Hurst and the Guy's Hospital Reports; the record of a great editorship, 1921-39. Guy's Hosp. Rep., Lond., 1939, 89: 375-96.—[Biography] J. Am. M. Ass., 1941, 116: 642.—Cameron, H. C. Sir Arthur Hurst; an appreciation. Guy's Hosp. Gaz., Lond., 1939, 53: 245, portr.— Nineteen years of editorship. Med. Press & Circ, Lond. 1940. 201: 278.—Portrait. Guvs Hosp. Rep., Lond., 1939, 89: No. 4, front.—R., J. A. A note on Sir Arthur Hurst's contributions to medical science and literature. Guy's Hosp. Gaz., Lond., 1939, 53: 212-4, portr. ----& STEWART, Matthew J. duodenal ulcer, xvii, 544p. 10 pl [etc.] Oxford L'niv. press, 1929. HURST, Charles Chamberlain, Experiments in genetics, xxiv, 578p. 85 pl. map. 4° Cambr., Engl., Univ. press, 1925. ---- The mechanism of creative evolution. xxi, 365p. 119 illust. portr. 8? Cambr., Engl., Lniv. press, 1932. ---- Heredity and the ascent of man. ix, 138p. illust. 8? Cambr., Engl., Univ. press, 1935. For portrait see Rep. Internat. Conf. Genet. (1906) 1907, 3. Conf., opp. 70. HURST, Nora, P. Hospital housekeeping and sanitation. 155p. 16? S. Louis, C.V. Mosby co., 1926. HURST, R. O., ed. studies. Books I—III facs. tab. U'irm, press, 1934-37. HURST, W. W. Dithizone method for the determination of lead. p.108-19. 24'Sem. New South Wales, Australasian M. Pub. co., 1939. In Murray, R. Elliott: Plumbisin and chronic nephritis in young people in Queensland. HURSTEL, Raoul, 1901- *Les accidents oculaires du travail; essai de statistique et de prophylaxie. 108p. 8? Par., M. Vigne, 1931. HURT, Harriett Jeanne. See Hurt. H. \V., & Hurt, H. J. The 1939 College blue book. 4. ed. 756p. 24cm. Deland, Fla., 1940. ---- & HURT, Huber William. The 1939 College blue book; a research analysis; the stan- dard book of reference of colleges and universi- ties of the United States of America; colleges of liberal arts and sciences, technical and profes- sional schools. 4. ed. 756p. incl. map. 24cm. DeLand, Ma. [1940] HURTADO, Alberto, PONS, Julio, & MERINO, Cesar. La anemia de la enfermedad de Carrion (Verruga peruana) 206p. pl. (part col.) tab. (part fold.) diagr. 24^cm. [Lima, Libr. & Impr. Gil] 1938. HURTADO GALTES, Felix. Designacion del Prof. Dr Felix Hurtado, de la Habana, como miembro correspondiente de la Sociedad. Arch, argent pediat., 1940, 14: 198.—Profesor Felix Hurtado Galtes. Bol. Soc. cubana pediat., 1937, 9: 381, portr. HURTER, Herbert Richard, -1940. Obituary. Brit. M. J., 1940, 1: 999. Also Lancet, Lond, 1940, 1: 1099. HURTLEY, William Holdsworth, 1865-1936. Obituary. Biochem. J., Lond., 1936, 30: 1 787. Also Lancet Lond., 1936, 1: 1367. HURTMANNS, Willi, 1907- *Zur Klinik der Porphvrie [Giessen] 18p. 8? Wiirzb., K. Triltsch, 1937. HURTY, John Newell, 1852-1925. Rice. T. B. [Biography] Month. Bull. Indiana Bd Health, 1939, 42: 107-10; passim. HURTZIG, Paul Friedrich, 1900- *Die chronisch adhaesive Mediastinopericarditis und ihre Behandlung durch Cardiolvse. 28p. 8? Rostock, W. H. Winterberg, 1928. HURVITZ, Joseph, 1909- *Ueber die Beeinflussung des Fettjfehaltes der Leber bei kastrierten und hormonbehandelten Ratten 23p. 20Ucm. Bonn, A. Brand, 1938. HIRWICZ, Natan, 1907- *Le meta- bolisme des lipides dans les maladies mentales. 72p. S? Par., L. Rodstein, 1934. HURWITZ, Benno [FrichJ 18S9 *Ueber Inversio uteri puerperal is. 51 p. 8? Konigsb H. Jaeger, 1914. HURWITZ, Siegmund. *Fahrende Zahn- iirzte im alten Zurich; ein Beitrag zur Geschiclite 8? Turben- der Zahnheilkunde [Zurich] 41 p. thai, R. Furrer's Erben, 1929. HUSA, William John, 1896- Pharma- ceutical dispensing; a textbook for students of pharmaceutical compounding and dispensing vii [2] 428p. illust. 8? Iowa City, la., Husa bros, 1935. ALso2.ed. xi, 794p. illust. 23V>cm 1941. HUSCHBECK, Konrad. *Ueber schwere Anamie wahrend der Schwangerschaft unter Berucksichtigung eines Falles aus der Gottinger Universitats-Frauenklinik (Auszug) [Gottingen] 7p. 8? Seesen a. Harz, V. H. Hofmann, 1920. HUSCHKE, Emi!, 1797-185S. Mimischc und physiognomische Studien. iii, 80p. portr. 8? Radebeul/Dresden, Madaus & co. [1931] For portrait, photograph, see Collection in Library. HUSCHKE, Ernst, 1908- *Ueber einen kriminalistisch bemerkenswerten Fall vom Zu- standekommen einer todlichen Halsschnittver- letzung im Streit durch ein zerbrochenes Bierglas. 30p. pl. 8? Miinch., Bayer. Druck, 1934. HUSEMANN, Annemarie, 1908- *Ueber einen Fall von einseitiger querer Gesichtsspalte, kombiniert mit Auricularanhang und Atresie des Gehorgangs [Munchen] 23p. 8? Bonn, H. Trapp, 1935. HUSEMANN, Friedrich. Goethe und die Ileilkunst; Betrachtungen zur Krise in der Medizin. 176p. 8? Dresd., E. Weise [1936] HUSEMANN, Friedrich, 1907- *Die Dauerschadigungen nach komplizierten Schadel- basisbruchen. 28p. 8? Wiirzb., F. Staudenraus, 1934. HUSEMANN, Gisbert, 1907- *l)ie Methoden der operativen Knochenbruchvercini- gung (Osteosynthese) an der Schenkelhals- fraktur und Mitteilung von drei Fallen von Bolzung bei Pseudarthrose. 27p. fol. Freib i. B., 1933. Mimeograph. HUSEN, Theo van, 1908- *Ueber einen Fall von Pick'scher Krankheit [Bonn] 18p. 8? Berl., W. deGruyter & Co., 1934. HUSER, Oswald. *Der inframandibulare Weg zur Entfernung des Zungenkarzinoms [Basel] 32p. 8? Sursee, J. Kungs Erben, 1929. HUSER, Remigius, 1901- *Zur Anatomie des Wildschweines (Sus scrofa L.) I. Beitrag: Literatunibersicht und Skelettsystem. p.289- 320, 7 pl. 8? Ziir., O. Fussli, 1930. Also Arch. Julius Klaus Stift., 1929-30, 4: HUSIK, Maurice. *Primare, katarrhalische Lungenaktmomykose bei einem 12 Wochen alten Kind [Zurich] 14p. 8? Berl., J. Springer, Also Virchows Arch., 1928, 268: 819-24. HUSLER, Leo, 1891- *Untersuchungen uber die Verwendung hoher dosierter Arsenik- praparate, insbesondere uber die Verwendung des kolloidalen Arseniks zur Devitahsation der Pulpa. 31p. 7 pl. 8? Bonn, L. Neuendorff, iyoi. HUSMANN, Anneliese, 1908- *Sozial- hygienische Bedeutung der Invalidenversiche- rung [Munster] 32p. 8? Diisseld., G. II. Nolte, 1929. HUSNI 907 HUSTED HUSNI, Jalloul. *Sur la broche de Kirschner appliquee au traitement des fractures chez l'enfant. 20p. 22 y2cm. Lausanne, Impr. Held, 1937. HUSS, Magnus, 1807-90. [Biographv In Portr. Svenska lak. apotek. (Sjoberg, N ) Stockh.. 1910. 55. HUSS, Ragnar Helmer, 1897- Studien uber die Schultz-Charltonsche Ausloschreaktion bei Scharlach. 148p. 8? Uppsala, Almqvist & Wiksell, 1933. Forms Suppl. 3, v. 14, Acta paediat. HUSSEIN, Aly, 1895- *Die heute herr- schenden Ansichten in der Paradentitisfrage 39p. 8? Bonn, P. Kubens, 1930. HUSSEINI, Mohammed, 1907- *Die Anal-Leiden und ihre Behandlung bei den Arabern. 38p. 8? BerL, R. Pfau, 1933. HUSSEL, Fritz, 1904- *Erfahrungen bei der Anwendung von Leben-Go-Mischvaccine in der Behandlung hartnackiger und chronischer Gonorrhoe [Munster] 30p. 8? Ansbach, M. Sehraut, 1932. HUSSELS, Friedrich Fritz Wilhelm, 1892- *Beitrage zur Kenntnis der juvenilen Paralyse mit besonderer Berucksichtigung der Augen- symptome [Frankfurt] 32p. 8? BerL, G Reimer, 1917. HUSSELS, Hans, 1912- *R6ntgeno- graphische L'ntersuchungen von Pulvern zahn- arztlicher Zemente. 23p. 8? Lpz., A. Edelmann, 1935. HUSSELS, Kate [geb. Ferchland] 1897- *Pemphigus vulgaris bei Graviditat. 19p. 8° BerL, E. Ebering, 1929. HUSSENSTEIN, Jean, 1900- ^'osteo- myeiite des os plats du crane consecutive aux lesions des teguments qui les recouvrent. 115p. 8? Par., Jouve & cie, 1931. HUSSET, Jean Prosper Francois, 1909- *Etude des principaux facteurs du diagnostic clinique. 160p. 8? Par., M. Lavergne, 1937. HUSSEY, Edward John, 1883-1934. Obituary. Tr. Am. Acad. Ophth. Otolar., 1935, 40: 477. HUSSEY, Marguerite Mallard. Teaching for health, xiv, 312p. 8? N. Y., N. Y. Univ. Bookstore, 1938. HUSSMANN, Adolf, 1907- *Beitrage zur Klinik und Differentialdiagnose des Lungen- oarcinoms [Jena] 48p. 8? Dresd., Keller & Hussmann, 1933. HUSSON, Andre Emmanuel, 1910- *Etude spectro-photometrique de la reaction de Liebermann-Burchard [Lyon] 134p. 8? Tr6- vaux, G. Patissier, 1936. HUSSON, Jean, 1915- *Resultats du traitement de l'ectopie testiculaire chez l'enfant d'apres 144 observations. 95p. 24^cm. Lyon, Impr. Salut Pub., 1939. HUSSON, Marc Julius, 1905- *Les tuberculoses animales aux colonies frangaises [Alfort] 50p. 8? Par., Le Frangois, 1929. HUSSON, Paul, 1911- Contribution a l'etude des ruptures et desinsertions du tendon distal du biceps brachial. llOp. 25cm. Lyon, C. Berlioz, 1938. HUSSONG, Hans Kurt, 1912- '"Konsti- tution und Klimakterium. 38p. 20^cm. Er- langen, K. Dores, 1938. HUSTE, Gerhard, 1901- *Behandlung der Arthritis deformans und des chronischen Gelenkrheumatismus mit Injektionen von Sehwe- felpraparaten. 27p. 8? Lpz., A. Edelmann, 1927. HUSTED, Erik. *Om tubercelbacilpaavisning med henbhk paa dennes anvendelse i den kliniske diagnostik. 130p. 8? Kbh., Levin & Munks- gaard, 1930. HUSTEDT, Friedrich Carl, 1886- Von Sammeln und Praparieren der Kieselalgen sowie Angaben uber Untersuchungs- und Kultur- methoden. p. 1-99. 8? BerL. Urban & Schwar- zenberg, 1939. 1939n APbtnn' Tb4 I ITOftSmeth- (Abderhalden, E.) Berl., HUSTEN, Karl. Anatomische und histolo- gische Untersuchungen iiber Weite und Wand der Hohlvenen unter physiologischen und patho- logischen Kreislaufbedingungen. 84p. 8° Jena G. Fischer, 1926. Forms H. 16, v.4, Veroff. Kriegs Konst. Path. ---- Die Staublungenerkrankung der Berg- leute im Ruhrkohlenbezirk (Ergebnisse patho- logisch-anatomischer Untersuchungen) 54p 8° Jena, G. Fischer, 1931. Forms H. 29, v.7, Veroff. Kriegs Konst. Path. HUSTON, Edward Minor, 1865-1940. [Obituary] Ohio M. J., 1940, 36: 1341. HUSTON, Ross, 1882-1938. [Obituary] Abstr. Proc. Ass. Life Insur. M. Dir. America 1938, 25: 291. HUSWEDEL, Johan Albert, 1618-74. Portrait. In Portr. Svenska lak. apotek. (Sjoberg, N.l Stockh., 1910, 56. HUSZAR, Gyorgy, 1905- *Die diagnos- tische und prognostische Bedeutung der Ery- throzytenscnkungsreaktion bei inneren Erkran- kungen (auf Grund der Erfahrungen der Medi- zinischen Universitats-Klinik in Munster i. W.) [Munster i. W.] 53p. 8? Quakenbruck, R. Kleinert, 1928. HUSZCZY, Adama. Zarys wsp61czesnej meto- dyki badari lotniczo-lekarskich. . viii, 106p. illust. ch. 8? Warsz., Nak. Kom. Propag. Med., 1936. HUTAN, Pierre, 1893- Contribution a l'etude du traitement du bubon chancrelleux par le vaccin antistreptobacillaire de Nicolle. 15p. 8? Par., Presses Univ. France,"1927. HUTCHINGS, Richard Henry, 1869- A psychiatric word book; a lexicon of terms em- ployed in psychiatry and psychoanalysis de- signed for students of medicine and nursing and psychiatric social workers. 146p. 32? Utica, N. Y., State Hosp. press, 1930. Also 3. ed. 180p. 32? 1932. Also new ed. 226p. 13^cm. 1939. See also Cheney, C. O. Biography. Am. J. Psychiat., 1939-40, 96: 15-20.—Portrait. Ibid., frontisp. HUTCHINS, Frank Frazier, -1942. [Obituary] J. Am. M. Ass., 1942, 118: 1237. HUTCHINSON, Claude Burton, 1885- The linkage of certain aleurone and endosperm factors in maize, and their relation to other linkage groups, p. 1425-73. 8? Ithaca, N. Y., 1922/ Forms No. 60, Mem. Cornell Univ. Agr. Exp. Sta. HUTCHINSON, Claud MacKenzie, -1941. Butler, E. J. [Obituary] Nature, Lond., 1941, 148: 367. HUTCHINSON, E. D. Creative sex. 122p. 8° Lond., G. Allen & Unwin [1936] HUTCHINSON, Sir Jonathan, 1828-1913. [Biographyl Cat. Portr. R. Coll. Surgeons, Lond., 1930, 38. Also Med. Press & Circ, Lond., 1932, 133: 313-5, portr.— Bruce. G. M. Jonathan Hutchinson: the last of the multi- spccialists. Bull. N. York Acad. M., 1937. 13: 539-49. Also rcpr—Kelly, E. C. Selections from the writings of Sir Jona- than Hutchinson, 1828-1913. Mod. Classics 1940-41 5: 108-245, portr.—Klauder, J. V. [Biosiraphyl Med. Life, N Y., 1934, 41: 313-26, portr. Markley. A. J. Jonathan Hutchinson,' the General Special M. < Vnl.aur, Menasha, HUTCHINSON 908 HUTH 1936-37, 42: 99-105.—Narayanrao, V. B. [Biography] Ind. J. Vener. His., 1938, 4: 193, portr.—Obituary. Brit. M. J., 1933, 1: 634.—Power, D'A. Sir Jonathan Hutchinson; a great teacher. In his Mirror for Surgeons, Bost., 1939, 173-80. [HUTCHINSON] Robert Hare, 1887- The doctor's first murder. 288p. 8? Lond., Hurst & Blackett [1933] HUTCHINSON, Woods, 1862-1930. The doctor in war. xv, 481 p. 24 pl. 8? Bost., Houghton Mifflin co., 1918. --- The new handbook of health. 4 p. 1. 410p. 12? Bost., Houghton Mifflin co. [1926] See also Obituary. J. Am. M. Ass., 1930, 94: 1714. For portrait, photograph, see Collection in Library. HUTCHINSON'S triad. See under Syphilis, congenital. HUTCHISON, James Alexander, 1863-1929. Armstrong, G. E. [Biography] Surg. Gyn. Obst., 1931, 53: 404, pl. HUTCHISON, Joseph C. Treatise on physi- ology and hygiene for educational institutions and general readers. 4. eds. (1884, 1888, 1895, 1898) 12? N. Y., Clark & Maynard, 1884-98. ---- Lessons in phvsiology and hygiene, in two books. 2. eds. (1895; 1902) 12° N. v Mavnard & Merrill, 1895; 1902. HUTCHISON, Sir Robert, 1871- Lec- tures on diseases of children. 5. ed. xii, 459p. pl. 8? Lond., E. Arnold & co., 1925. Also 6. ed. viii, 487p. 8? 1931. Also 7. ed. viii, 452p. illust. 8? [1936] Also 8. ed. with A. Moncriff. viii, 47lp. 22^cm. [1940] ---- The elements of medical treatment. vi, 163p. 12? Brist., J. Wright & sons, 1926. Also 2. ed. 188p. 8? 1932. Also 3. ed. [8] 194p. 12? 1937. ---- Lectures on dyspepsia. 2. ed. 200p. 8? Lond., Bailliere, Tindall & Cox, 1927. ---- Some principles of diagnosis, prognosis, and treatment; a trilogy. 3 p. 1. 54p. 12? Lond., S. Marshall, 1928. Also 2. ed. 4p., 53p. 12? Brist., J. Wright & sons [1937] HUTCHISON, Robert. Harvey; the man, his method, and his message for us today: being the Harveian oration delivered before the Royal College of Physicians of London on October 19th, 1931. 26p. 8? Oxf., Clarendon press, 1931. HUTCHISON, Robert, 1871- , [et al.] An index of treatment bv various authors. 8. ed. xviii, 1021p. illust." 26cm. Brist., J. Wright & sons, 1921. Also 11. ed. xv, 1020p. 8? 1936. Also 12. ed. xv. 996p. 261/2cm. 1940. HUTCHISON, Robert, & HUNTER, Donald. Clinical methods, a guide to the practical study of medicine. 9. ed. xii [1] 684p. 16? Lond., Cassell & co., 1929. Also 10. ed. xii p. 1. 658p. 16° 1935. Also 11. ed. xiii, 622p. 16cm. 1940. HUTCHISON, Robert, & MOTTRAM, V. H. Food and the principles of dietetics. 7. ed. xvi, 630p. 8? Lond., E. Arnold & co., 1933. Also 8. ed. xxvii, 634p. 8? [1936] Also 9 ed. xxvii, 648p. 22cm. Bait., The Williams & Wilkins co., 1940. HUTCHISON, Robert, & WAUCHOPE, G. M. For and against doctors; an anthology. 168p 8? Bait., W. Wood & co., 1935. See also Presentation to Dr Robert Hutchison. Lancet, Lond., 1939, 1: 595, portr.—Robert Hutchison's portrait- presentation ceremony. Brit. M. J., 1939, 1: 510.—Testimonial to Dr Hutchison. Lancet, Lond., 1938, 2: 217. HUTH, Elmore. *The use of fresh apple pulp in diarrhea in infants and children. 16p 4° Milwaukee, Wis., 1933. Typewritten. HUTH, Erich. *Bestimmung der Isodosen verschiedener Mesothorium- und Radium priipa- rate und Praparatekombinationen im Wasser - phantom, p.358-82. 8? Freib. i. B. [n. pub ] 1924. Also Strahlentherapie, 1925, 19: HUTH, Jiirgen, 1908- *Angina maligna und Tonsillektomie [Greifswald] 19p. 21cm Bitterfeld, Schencke, 1938. HUTH, Walter [Ernst Paul Wilhelm] 1901- *Ueber die Gefassnaht. 45p. 8? BerL, Bero- lina, 1928. HUTHMACHER, Klemens Karl, 1899- *Ueber die entwicklungshemmende und keim- totende Kraft von atherischen Oelen. 12p. 21cm. Giessen [n. pub.] 1938. Also Deut. Apoth. Ztg, 1938, 53: HUTIN, Emile, 1905- *L'absence con- genitale du vagin (traitement chirurgical) 75p, 8? Par., Jouve & cie, 1936. HUTINEL, Jean, 1890-1933. See Aubry, M., Hutinel, J. [et al.] Syphilis viscerale. 760p. 8? Par., 1934. See also Allocution de M. Apert, president k l'occasion du deces de M. Jean Hutinel. Bull. Soc. m6d. hdp. Par., 1933, 3. ser., 49: 259-61.—Babonneix, L. Necrologie. Gaz. h6p., 1933, 106: 306.—Bezancon, F. [Necrologie] Presse med. 1933, 41: 428.—Mouquin, M., & Arnette, L. [N6crologic Bull, mid., Par., 1933, 47: 211.—[Necrologie] Bull. Soc. m6d. hop., Par., 1934, 3. ser., 49: 1664-70. ----& CAYLA, Alfred. Affections des bronehes et des poumons. p.233-443. 4? Par., 1934. In Traits med. enf. (Nobecourt & Babonneix) Par., 1934, 3: HUTINEL, Jean, & LINOSSIER-ARDOIN, Alice. L'her6do-syphilis; clinique et thera- peutique. xi, 302p. pl. 8? Par., Gauthier- Villars & cie, 1932. HUTINEL, Victor Henri, 1849-1933. Les dystrophies de Tadolescence; etudes cliniques 232p. illust. 23cm. Par., Masson & cie, 1924. ----Le terrain her6do-syphilitique; apercu de pathologie generale et de clinique infantiles. 455p. 8? Par., Masson & cie., 1926. ---- Le syndrome malin dans les maladies de I'enfance; apercu de clinique et de pathologie g6nerale infantile, xi, 305p. 8? Par., Masson & cie, 1927. See also Barth elemy. R. Necrologie. Bull, med., Par., 1933, 47: 331.—Farreras, P. Victor Henri Hutinel. Rev. espafi. med. cir., 1933, 16: 375-7, portr.—Lereboullet, P. Victor Hutinel, medecin de l'Hospice des Enfants AssistiV Paris m6d., 1934, 91: 317-28.—[Necrologie] Bull. Soc. med. hop. Pari , 1934, 3. ser., 49: 1670-82. Also J. mid. chir., Par., 1933, 104: 373-6.—Nobecourt P. [Necrologie] Arch, argent. pediat., 1933, 4: 675-80. Also Presse med., 1933, 41: 595. ------Hutinel; professeur de clinique medicale des enfants. Gaz. hop., 1933, 106: 1689-98.—[Obituary] Med. nifios, 1933, 34: 161.—Piaggio Garzon, W. Rindiendo homenaje al Profesor Victor Hutinel por el Dr Wralter Piaggio Garz6n. An. Fac. med., Montev., 1933, 18: 656-60, portr. Also Med. nifios, 1934, 35: 65-9.— Rist [Necrologie] Bull. Acad, med., Par., 1933, 3. ser., 109: 467-72.—Roussy. G. Inauguration du monument V. Hutinel k l'Hopital des Enfants-Malades. Gaz. hop., 1933, 106: 1687. HUTMANN, Helmut, 1900- *Ncuerc Versuche iiber die Vergarung des Traubenzuckers. 38p. 8? Miinch. [P. Waizmann] 1926. HUTT, Cecil Williams, 1880-1934, & THOM- SON, Henry Hyslop. Principles and practice of preventive medicine. 2v. xvii, xi, 1688p. paged consec. illust. diagrs. 8? Lond., Methuen & co. [1935] See also Obituary. Lancet, Lond., 1934, 2: 516. HUTTEN, Ulrich von, 1488-1523. Dialogi. [68] 1. 8? Mainz, Joh. Scheffer, 1520. See also Ho]born, H. Ulrich von Hutten. 175p. 8? Lpz.. 1929. Also G., M. Un vdrole tres prficieux: Ulric von Hutten. Progr. med., Par., 1925, 40: 7.—Lafourcade, L. Le chevalier Ulrich de Hutten et le traitement de la syphilis pendant la renaissance. Paris med., 1930, 76: (annexe) 215-7. HUTTER 909 HUXHAM HUTTER, Antonie. Het constitutioneel fami- lie-beeld bij de schizophrenie; een onderzoek naar de psychotische en karakterologische belasting en naar de wijze van overerven. 4 p. 1. 220p. 8? Zutphen, Nauta & co., 1925. HUTTER, Konrad [Fritz] 1912- *Ueber Eihautveranderungen im Bereich der Chorion- blasen des Hausschweines (Sus scrofa domestica) 42p. 5 pl. 8? Lpz., A. Edelmann, 1935. HUTTER, Marianne. *Zur posttraumatischen Wirbelkorpernekrose (Kummell'sche Spondylitis) unter besonderer Berucksichtigung ihrer Diffe- rentialdiagnose [Munchen] 31p. 2 pl. 8? Speyer, Pilger, 1935. HUTTON, Isabel Galloway Emslie, 1887- The sex technique in marriage [3. ed., 1. Ameri- can ed.] xx p., 160p. illust. 8? N. Y., Emerson books, 1932. ---- The last of the taboos; mental disorders in modern life, xiii, 204p. 8? Lond., W. Heine- mann, 1934. ---- The hygiene of the change in women (the climacteric) ix, llOp. 8? Lond., W. Heine- mann, 1936. ---- Woman's prime of life; making the most of maturity. 150p. 8? N. Y., Emerson books, 1937. HUTTON, J. E. Welfare and housing; a practical record of war-time management, viii, 192p. front. 11 pl. 2 plans. 12? Lond., Longmans, Green & co., 1918. HUTTON, Laura. The single woman and her emotional problems, xi, 150, lp. 16? Lond., Bailliere, Tindall & Cox, 1935. HUTTON, Lefferts, 1879-1935. [Obituary] Abstr. Proc. Ass. Life Insur. M. Dir. America, 1936, 22: 3. HUTTON, Maurice, 1856-1940. Falconer, R. A. [Obituary] Tr. R. Soc. Canada, 1940, 34: Proc, 111-4, portr. HUTTON, R. M. Lead poisoning (a compila- tion of present knowledge) viii, 304p. 8? Toronto, C. W. James, 1923. HUTYRA, Ferencz, 1860-1934, & MAREK, Jozsef. Special pathology and therapeutics of the diseases of domestic animals. 3. Am. ed. from the 6. German ed. by John R. Mohler & Adolph Eichhorn. 3v. 4? Chic, A. Eger, 1926. ---& MANNINGER, Rudolf. The same. 4. Engl. ed. 3v. illust. (part col.) 19 col. pl. 25cm. Lond., Bailliere, Tindall & Cox, 1938. For anniversary number see Kozl. osszehas. eiet & k6rt., 1928, 22: portr. ' , , ,„„r See also Blieck, de [Obituary] Tschr. diergeneesk., 1935, 62: 453-6, portr.—Manninger, R. F. von Hutyra zum 40. Jahreswechsel seiner Ernennung zum o. 6. Professor an der Tierarztlichen Hochschule in Budapest. Deut. tierarztl. Wschr. 1929, 37: 49-51. ------ [Obituary] Allatorv. lap., 1935, 58: 1-4.—Marek, J. Nekrolog. Prag. tierarztl. Arch., 1935, 15: 1-3—Preisz, H. [Obituary] Orv. hetil., 1935, 79: 25. HUWE, Joachim, 1911- *Das Durch- schnittsgewicht der ausgetragenen neugeborenen Kinder der letzten 25 Jahre in Pommern. 16p. 22cm. Greifswald, H. Adler, 1938. HUWYLER, Benedikt. *Zur Anatomie des Schweineherzens; Untersuchung des Kammerin- nern bei Sus scrofa domesticus [Zurich] 32p. 8? Weimar, R. Wagner Sohn, 1926. Also Anat. Anz., 1926-27, 62: 49-76. HUXEL, Ludwig, 1910- *Ueber die Geschwulste der Appendix insbesondere die Karzinoide [Heidelberg] 23p. 22#cm. Wiirzb., K. Triltsch, 1936. HUXEL, Viktor. *Die Kreislaufstorungen der Thymusdruse [Heidelberg] 43p. pl. 21cm. Wurzb., K. Triltsch, 1936. HUXHAM, John, 1692-1768. 676-80rUh' J* [Biographyl Am- J- Dif5. Child., 1931, 41: HUXLEY, Henry M. c £eelreItz?!'' C- 9v* Contributions to the racial anthropology of the Near East. 62p. 24Hcm. Cambr., Mass., 1940 HUXLEY, Julian Sorrell, 1887- Problems of relative growth, xix, 276p. 105 illust pl 8? Lond., Methuen & co. [1932] ---- A scientist among the Soviets, viii p 1 142p. 8? N. Y., Harper & bros, 1932. ----Problems in experimental embryology; being the 36th Robert Boyle Lecture. 17p. 8? [Lond.] Oxford Univ. press, 1935. ---- Science and social needs, xvi", 287p. illust. pl. diagrs. 8? N. Y., Harper bros, 1935. ---- Essays of a biologist. 245p. 18cm. Harmondsworth, Middlesex, Eng., Penguin books ltd [1939] ■---- Man stands alone [2. ed.] x p. 11. 297p. 22^2cm. N. Y., Harper & bros [1941] ---- & De BEER, Gavin Rylands. The ele- ments of experimental embryology, xii p. 1 1. 514p. illust. diagrs. 8? Cambr., Engl., Univ. press, 1934. See also Haldane, J. B. S., & Huxley, J. Animal biology. 344p. 12? Oxf., 1927. Also Huxley, Thomas Henry. T. H. Huxley's diary of the voyage of H. M. S. Rattlesnake. 301p. 8? N. Y., 1936. Also Wells, H. G., Huxley, Julian S., & Wells, G. P. The science of life. 2v. 8? Garden City, N. Y., 1931. ------i Biology of the human race. 205p. 8? Lond. [1937] ------ How animals behave. 263p. 8? Lond. [1937] HUXLEY, Thomas Henry, 1825-95. Grund- ziige der Physiologie. 4. Aufl. xviii, 481p. 8? Hamb., Leopold Voss, 1910. ---■ T. H. Huxley's diary of the voyage of H. M. S. Rattlesnake; edited from the unpub- lished MS. by Julian Huxley, xiv, 301p. illust. pl. portr. facs. map. 8? N. Y., Doubleday, Doran & co., 1936. See also Ayres, C. E. Huxley. 254p. 8! N. Y. [1932] Also Huxley memorial lectures, 1925-32. [177]p. 8! Lond., 1932. Also Peterson, H. Huxley, prophet of science. 338p. 8? Lond., 1932. See also [Biography] Cat. Portr. R. Coll. Surgeons, Lond., 1930, 82. Also Med. Rec, N. Y., 1938, 147: 137.—Bolton, S. K. Thomas Henry Huxley. In her Famous Men of Sc, N. Y., 1938, 319-33.—Smith. G. E. The place of Thomas Henry Huxley in anthropology; Huxley Memorial Lecture, 1935. J. R. Anthrop. Inst. Gr. Britain, 1935, 65: 199-204.—T. H. Huxley as anthropologist. Nature, Lond., 1935, 136: 863. ---- & YOUMANS, William Jay. Elements of physiology and hygiene; a text-book for educa- tional institutions. 420p. 8? N. Y., D. Apple- ton & Co., 1868. Also [2. ed.] 485p. 1873. HUXLEY memorial lectures; 1925-32. [177] p. 8? Lond., Macmillan & co., 1932. HUXOLL, Erich, 1908- *Spatblutungen im Wochenbett durch Thrombenlosung. 30p. 8? Bonn, A. Brand, 1934. HUYBRECHTS, Maurice, 1877- Le pH et sa mesure; les potentiels d'oxydo-reduction le rH. 2. ed. 2 p. 1. 394p. 12? Par., Masson & cie, 1932. HUYEN, P. V. La vaccination antirabique chez les animaux; recherches sur un vaccin glycero-formol6. 126p. 8? Par., P. Boussuet, 1930. HUYGENS, Christian, 1629-95. Traite de la lumiere ou sont expliquees les causes de ce qui luy arrive dans la reflexion, & dans la refraction. et particulierement dans l'Strange refraction du cristal d'Islande, par C. H. D. Z., avec un discours de la cause de la pesanteur. 4 p. 1. 180p. 8? Leide, Pierre Vander Aa, 1690. See also Bell, A. E. The Horologium oscillatorium of Christian Huygens. Nature, Lond., 1941, 148: 245-8.— Vollgraff, J. A. Deux pages consecutives du manuscrit G. de Chr. Huygens. Janus, Leiden, 1940, 44: 10-23. ------ HUYGENS 910 HYALODIDYMEAE Demonstration mecanique des theoremes de Tschirnhaus considers dans le T. XX des Oeuvres completes de Chr. Huygen«. Ibid., 198-201. HEYS, Thomas. James, R. R. Thomas Huys, M. D., physician to Mary Tudor. Janus, Leyden, 1936, 40: 171-7. HI YSMANS, Joris Karl, 1848-1907. Sec Rolland, P. A. H. 'Etude psychopathologique sur le mysticisme de J. K. Huysmans [Paris] 35p. 8? Nice, 1930. HUYSSEN, Charles A. Untersuchungen zur Frage des Zusammenhanges der Rippenknorpel- und der Gefassverkalkungen (im Sinne der Arteriosclerose) [Zurich.] 25p. 8? Basel, B. Schwabe & Co., 1924. HUZEL, Rudolf, 1912- Heber einen Fall von Morbus Bang beim Kind [Tubingen] 24p. 21cm. Stuttg., C. Belser, 1937. HWANG, Tschon Djian, 1903- *Ueber ein primares Plattenepithelcarcinom des Nieren- beckens (mit Steinbildung) mit Eindringen von Carcinomzellen in Harnkanalchen und Bow- mansche Kapseln. 24p. 8? Gott. [n. pub.] 1929. HWASS, Thorbjorn, 1852-1927. Marcus, H. [Obituary] Hygiea, Stockh., 1927, 89: 145-52. HWASSER, Israel, 1790-1860. [Biography] In Portr. Svenska lak. apotek. (Sjoberg, N.) Stockh., 1910, 50, portr.-—Johnsson, G. [Causes of diseases by Israel Hwasser] Uppsala lak. foren. forh., 1933, 38: 1-164.— Quensel, U. Israel Hwasser och hans tid. Ibid., Art. I, 36, port r. HY, Robert, 1903- *L'intradermo-rcac- tion a la levurine (etude clinique et biologique) 102p. 3 pl. 8? Par., A. Legrand, 1930. HYACINTH. Boyd, K. J. Compound for destroying water hyacinths, and method. U. S. Patent Off., 1941, No. 2,248,159.—Femme (La) au li> .Martagon; dessin du Maitre E. S. Aesculape, Par., 1938, 28: 88. HYALIN [and hyaline bodies] Ahhexs, E. *Zur Genese der Runsel'schen Korperchen. 15p. 21cm. Weende-Gott., 1937. Bungenberg de Jong, H. G., & Hartkamp, J. L. L. F. On the formation of hyaline vesicles at the surface of Paramecium caudaturn; contribution to the knowledge of the plasma mem- brane. Protoplasma, 1938, 31: 550-87— Gersh, I., & Tarr, A. D. The so-called hvaline bodies of herring in the posterior lobe of the hypophysis. Anat. Rec, 1935-36, 63:231-8.—Loeschcke, H. Vorstellungen iiber das "Wesen von Hyalin und Amyloid auf Grund von serologischen Versuchen. Beitr. path. Anat., 1927, 77: 231-9, pl.—Pescatori, F. Contributo istopatologico alio studio della morfologia e patogenesi dei corpi ialini nei tessuti. Sperimentale, 1931, 85: 25-52, pl. HYALINOSIS. See also under names of organs and tissues affected. Heine, I. Ueber einen Fall von hyalin-bindegewebiger Degeneration des Herzens, der Nieren und der Schilddriise. Beitr. path. Anat., 1923-24, 72: 590-*. Hesse, M. Ueber das Wesen der Hyalinose der kleiuon Ainiien auf Grund der Untersuchung vqn Kindermilzeii. \"ii r-liow- Arch., 1934, 292: 405-78.—Miiller, E. Untersuchungen iiber Wesen und Entstehumrsbediugungen des bindegewebigen Hvalins. Beitr. path. Anat,, 1936, 97: 41-80.—Randerath. E. Seltene Hyalin- ablagerung im Gehirn, in der linken Lunge, den beiden Neben- nieren und der Schilddriise. Ibid., 1928, 81: 145-71, pl.— Wlassics. T. Pigment-Hvalinentartung nach Rontgenbestrah lung. Derm. Wschr., 1936. 102: 800-2. HYALITIS. See under Vitreous. HYALOCOCCUS. See Trichosporon. HYALODENDRON. Diddens, H. A. Eine neue Pilzgattung, Hyalodendrori. Bakt., 2. Abt., 1934, 90: 315-9. HYALODIDYMEAE. See Fungi imperfecti. HYALOID artery. See also Eye, Abnormities; Lens; Vitreous. Fischer, E. *Ein Gliom bei pcrsistierender Arteria hyaloidea [Tubingen] 13p. 8? Schram- berg-Schwarz., 1933. Ancona, S. [Case of persistence of von Szilv's coupling] Ned. tschr. geneesk., 1935, 79: 135-50, pl.- Dejean. ('. Por- sistance de Fartere livnloidicnne et du canal dc < loiuiel (bio- mieroscopie) Arch, opht,, Par., 1930, 47: 459-03.—FinnofT W. ('. Persist.'Ut h.\aloid arteiy. Tr. Am. Ophth. Soe., 192:;. 21: 133.—Genet & Arnal. Persistance de 1'artdre livaloi.lo et. du canal de Cloquet. Lyon med., 1924, 133: 570. Gibson, J. L. Unusual amount of connective tissue around persistent hyaloid artery; simulating glioma. Australas. M. Gaz., 1901, 20: 213.—Heine, L. Angeborene Bindegewebsmasse hinter der Linse mit Art, hyaloid, pers. ein Gliom vortauschend: zugleich ein Nachtrag zu meiner Arbeit iiber das Septum I'mn tale. Zschr. Augenh., 1925-6, 58: 194-0, pl.- Hoffmann. H. Ueber eine seltene Strangbildung im Augenhintergrund i Ai lerin hyaloidea persistens) Klin. Mbl. Augenh., 1920, 77: .'570 ,n les Ixodidae du genre Hyalomma Koch; Hyalomma schulzei Olene, 1931. Ibid., 1937, 15: 419-30. ------ Description de Hyalomma dromedarii (Koch, 1844) morphologie de la larve et de la nymphe. Ibid., 481-6. ------ & Gouchey, S. H. Biologie de Hyalomma dromedarii (Koch, 1844) Ibid., 187 99.—Schuize, P. Die Zeckengattung Hyalomma I. 'H aegyptium L., detritum P. Sch., volgense P. Sch. U. Schlottke H. scupense P. Sch. und H. uralense P. Sch. und Schlottke) Zschr. Parasitenk., 1930-31, 3: 22-48.- Senevet, G. Hyalom- ma mauritanicum et Hyalomma lusitanicuni. Arch! Inst. Pasteur Algerie, 1928, 6: 3.5-41. HYALOSTILBOIDEAE. See Stilbaceae. HYALURONIDASE. Hobby, G. L., Dawson, M. H. [et al.l The relationship between spreading factor and hyaluronidase. J. Exp. M., 1941, 73: 109-23. Also repr.—Lyth, L. G. Hyaluronidase. Brit. M. J., 1941, 2: 788.—Meyer, K., & Chaffee, E. Hyaluron- idases of animal and bacterial origin. J. Biol. Chem., 1941. HYALURONIDASE 911 HYBRID 140- Proc 91.—Meyer, K., Chaffee, E. [et al.] Hyaluronidases of bacterial and animal origin. J. Exp. M., 1941, 73: 309-26. Meyer, K., Hobby, G. L. [et al.l The hydrolysis of hyaluronic acid by bacterial enzymes. Ibid., 1940, 71: 137-46. Also repr. HYATT, Thaddeus Pomeroy, 1S64- Teeth and their care. 43p. 16? Brooklyn, King press, 190G. ---- Hygiene of the mouth and teeth. 64p. 16? Brooklyn, Brooklyn Dent. Pub. co. [1929] HYBBINETTE, Samuel, 1876-1939. Asplund, G. [Obituary] Nord. med., 1939, 1: 693-8, portr.—[Biography] J. Am. M. Ass., 1939, 113: 436. HYBRID. See also Chimera; Crossing; Fertilization; Genetics; Inbreeding, etc. Antonius, O. Bemerkungen iiber Bastarde und Bastard- zucht. Biol, gen., 1932-33, 9: 2. Halfte, 39-47.—Castle, W. E. The explanation of hybrid vigor. Proc. Nat, Acad. Sc. U. S., 1926, 12: 16-9.—Cousin, G. Sur une methode graphique pour l'analyse de rhybridation, d'apres des recherches sur diverses espaces de grillons. C. rend. Acad, sc, 1939, 208: 1433-5.------ Sur la differenciation des hvbrides reciproques de premiere generation. C. rend. Soc. biol., 1939, 131: 80-3.— East, E. M. Heterosis. Genetics, 1936, 21: 375-97.—Franz, V. Ueber Bastardpopulationen in der Gattung Paludina (recte: Viviparus) Biol. Zbl., 1928, 48: 79-93.—Gini, C. Remarks on the explanation of heterosis. Sc. Papers Internat. Congr. Eugen. (19321 1934, 3. Congr.. 421-4.—Klingstedt, H. Failure of anaphase separation in species hybrids. Nature, Lond., 1938, 141: 606.—Livesay, E. A. An experimental study of hybrid vigor or heterosis in rats. Genetics, 1930, 15: 17-54.— Lynch, R. I. Natural hybrids. Rep. Internat. Conf. Genet. (1906) 1907, 3. Conf., 159-77.—Schnitzler, O. Untersuchungen iiber reziprok verschiedene Bastarde in der Gattung Epilobium. Zschr. indukt. Abstamm., 1932-33, 63: 305-56—Twitty, V. C. Correlated genetic and embrvological experiments on Triturus. J. Exp. Zool., 1936, 74: 239-302. ---- animal. Hertwig, P. Artbastarde bei Tieren. 140p. 261/2cm. Berl., 1936. Bellamy, A. W. Inter-specific hybrids in Platypoecilus: one species ZZ-WZ; the other XY-XX. Proc. U. S. Nat. Acad. Sc, 1936, 22: 531-6.—Bostand, J. Sur rhybridation du crapaud et de la grenouille rousse. C. rend. Soc. biol., 1933, 112: 1042.—Cat-dog (A) from North Carolina. J. Hered., 1937, 28: 115.—Cousin, G. Sur la stabilite des indices morpho- metriques, chez les especes de gryllides et chez leurs hybrides de premiere generation. C. rend. Soc. biol., 1939, 130: 1519- 21. ------ Sur une formule permettant l'estimation exacte et la comparaison des indices biometriques, chez des hybrides interspecifiques de gryllides et chez les criquets de phases differentes. C. rend. A'cad. sc, 1940, 210: 583-6.—Droogleever Fortuyn, A. B. A remarkable cross in Mus musculus. Genetica, Gravenh., 1934, 16: 321-59.—Eaton, O. N. The effect of crossing inbred lines of guinea-pigs upon the characteristics of the hybrids. In Animal Breed. Internat. Genet. Congr., 1939, 7. Congr., 38— Falkenstrom, G. Eine Kreuzung im Freie'n von Drosophila melanogaster cf und Dros. funebns 9 samt Beschreibung der Bastardgeneration und einiger Eier derselben. Genetica, Gravenh., 1939, 21: 41-69.—Goose-swan hvbrid bred in Munich zoo. Science News Lett., 19.34, 26: 359—Herve, G. Entre chien et loup (note d'hybndologic) Rev. anthrop., Par., 1931, 41: 201-19.—Keeler, C. E., & Cobb, V. Siamese-Persian cats. J. Hered., 1936, 27: 339-40, 3 figs.— Kosswig, C. Ueber Bastarde der Teleostier Platypoecilus und Xiphophorus; vorlaufige Mitteilung. Zschr. indukt. Abstamm., 1927 44- 253—Lenz, F. Ein mendelnder Artbastard; UeiJe- phila vespertilio 9 X euphorbiae cf. Arch. Rassenb. 1926, 18: 129-51 4 pl ------ Mitteilungen uber Art- und Gattungs- bastard'e bei Schmetterlingen. Zschr. indukt. Abstamm., 1926 41- 113-5.—Mark, R. Untersuchungen an Bastarden zwischen Kanarien und Wildfinken. Zschr. wiss. Zool., 1930, 137- 476-549 pl.—Mokeev, A. E. [Triple hybrid: banteng+ yak'+zebu] Priroda, Leningrad, 1936 25: 97-100.-Musgrave, E. W. A flock of unique hybrids. Sc. American 1926,13.>: 434 — Quinn, J. P., Burrows, W. H.. & Byerly. T. C. Turkey- chicken hybrids. J. Hered., 1937, 28: 169-73.-Rostand, J. Hybridation du crapaud cpmmun avec 2 bufonides exotiques. C. rend. Soc. biol., 1934, ^6: 431.-fSaint-Cyr] La question des 16porides. J. m6d. vet., Lyon, 1868, 24: 380-3.—Schon- mann, W. Der diploide Bastard Triton palmatus 9 X ?ala- mandra cf. Arch. Entwmech., 1938, 138: 345-75.—Ubisch, G v & Mello, R. F. Genetic studies on a cavy species cross,' Cavia rufescens Lund and Cavia porcellus LinnS. .1. Hered., 1940. 31: 389-98.-Weyer, F Em Zwitter von Cuta pipiens L. Zool. Anz., 1938, 123: 184-92.-W,egand K M A taxonomist's experience with hybrids in the wild. Srion<< 1935, 81: 161-6.—Wittmer, W. B^tardierungen■ «wischen Fuchs und Hund. Berl. tierarztl. Wschr., 1926, «. 277.-- Wright, S. An 8-factor cross in the guinea pig. Genetics, 1928, 13:508-31. ---- Characters. Anderson, O. D. The spontaneous neuro-muscular activitv ot various pure breeds of dog and of interbreed hybrids of the first and second generation. Am. J. Physiol., 1939, 126: 422__ Cavazza, F. I caratteri dei discendenti da ibri'di di specie normalmente infecondi per incompleta gametogenesi Arch zool., 1931, 16: 371-83.—Cousin, G. Le neotenie chez Gryllus campestns et ses hybrides. Bull. biol. France, 1938' 72- 79-118, pl.—Craft, W. A. The sex ratio in mules and other hybrid mammals. Q. Rev. Biol., 1938, 13: 19-40.—Funaoka S Der anatomische Bau des Blattes des Bastards Mirabilis 'ja- lapa L. x Mirabilis longiflora L., verglichen mit dem der Eltern- pflanzen. Zschr. indukt. Abstamm., 1925, 39: 288-93.— Ghigi, A. Intersessualita. da ibridazione. Boll. Soc. ital biol sper., 1934, 9: 704-8.—Hadorn, E. Ueber Organentwicklung und histologische Differenzierung in transplantierten mero- gonischen Bastardgeweben (Triton palmatus (9) X Triton cristatus-cf) Arch. Entwmech., 1931-32, 125: 495-565.— Heslop Harrison, J. W. (On the occurrence of triploid inter- sexes in hybrids of the lepidopterous genus Oporinia) Genetica, Gravenh., 1934, 15: 115-24.—James, W. T. Morphological form and its relation to reflex action and behavior; a study of pure breed and hybrid dogs by the conditioned salivary reflex Proc. Ass. Res. Nerv. Ment. Dis., 1934, 14: 28-54.—Karpe- chenko, G. D. The production of polyploid gametes in hybrids Hereditas, Lund, 1927, 9: 349-68.—Koltsova, M. P. [Analysis of the temperament of wild rats and their hybrids Fi] Biol J., Moskva, 1938, 7: 559-70.—Kosswig, C. Die geschlechtliche Differenzierung bei den Bastarden von Xiphophorus helleri und Platypoecilus maculatus und deren Nachkommen. Zschr. indukt. Abstamm., 1930-31, 57: 220-305.—Kostoff, D., & Arutiunova, N. S. Die Grosse der Zellen in den Fi-Bastarden und deren Eltern in Zusammenhang mit der Grosse der Bas- tarde (ein Beitrag zum Problem von Heterosis) Zschr. Zell- forschung, 1936, 24: 427-38.—Liithi, H. R. Die Differenzie- rungsleistungen von Transplantaten der letalcn Bastardkom- bination Triton 9 X Salamandra cf. Arch. Entwmech., 1938, 138: 423-50.—Pickard, J. N. Waved, a new coat type in rabbits. J. Genet., Cambr., 1941, 42: 215-22, pl.—Roche, V. de. Differenzierung von Geweben und ganzen Organen in Trans- plantaten des bastardmerogonischen Kombination Triton alpestris (9) X Triton palmatus cf. Arch. Entwmech., 1936-37, 135: 620-63.—Saunders, E. R. The history, origin and characters of certain interspecific hybrids in Nolana and their relation to Nolana paradoxa. J. Genet., Cambr., 1934, 29: 387-419, 4 pl.—Schwier, H. Geschlechtsbestimmung und -differenzierung bei Macropodus opercularis, concolor, chinensis und deren Artbastarden. Zschr. indukt. Abstamm., 1939, 77: 291-335.—Skalinska, M. Etudes sur la cytologie et la fertilite d'un hybride triploide d'Aquilegia. C. rend. Soc. biol., 1933, 113: 953-5.—Thiel, O. Das Haarkleid des Rexkaninchens und sein Verhalten bei der Kreuzung. Zschr. indukt. Abstamm., 1928, 48: 305-24.—Tschermak, E., & Tschermak, A. Zur mathematischen Charakteristik reiner Linien und ihrer Bas- tarde; nach Untersuchungen am Samengewicht von Bohnen. Hereditas, Lund, 1927, 9: 257-73.—Zawadowsky, M., & Zubina, E. Hahnenfederige Fasanenweibchen im Lichte der Embryogenese der Geschlechtsdrusen. Arch. Entwmech., 1929, 115: 52-92. ---- Chromosome behavior, and cytology. Afify, A. The cytology of the hybrid between Lycopersicum esculentum and L. racemigerum in relation to its parents. Genetica, Gravenh., 1933, 15: 225-40.—Bamford, R. Chromo- some number and hybridization in Gladiolus. J. Hered., 1941, 32: 418-22.—Bleier, H. Bastardkaryologie. Bibliogr. genet., Gravenh., 1934, 11: 393-489.—Brieger, F. Faktorenanalyse bei Sippenbastarden von Aquilegia vulgaris. Biol. Zbl., 1932, 52: 430-6.—Briicher, H. Die Nichtbeteiligung von Hemmungs- genen. Zschr. indukt. Abstamm., 1938, 75: 298-340.------ Die reziprok verschiedenen Art- und Rassenbastarde von Epilo- bium und ihre Ursachen; die Nichtbeteilung von Hemmungs- genen. Ibid., 298-340 [Erwiderung von E. Lehmann] 1939, 76:602. ------ Die reziprok verschiedenen Art-und Rassen- bastarde von Epilobium und ihre Ursachen; das genetisch selbstandige Zell plasma als Ursache der reziproken Unter- schiede. Ibid., 1939, 77: 455-87—Bytinski-Salz, H.. & Gunther, A. Untersuchungen an Lepidopterenhybriden; Morphologie und Cytologie einiger Bastarde der Celeriu Hybriden Galiphorbiae-Gruppe. Ibid., 1930, 53: 153-234. 4 pl.—Catcheside, D. G. Chromosome catenation in some Fi Oenothera hybrids. J. Genetics, Cambr., 1933, 27: 45-69.— Clausen, J. Preliminary account on the cytology of species and specific hybrids. Hereditas, Lund, 1931, 15: 62-6.— Cleland, R. E. The fulfillment of predictions as to chromosome configuration in hybrids of Oenothera, and its significance. Proc. Internat. Congr. Genetics, 1932, 2: 25.—Crew, F. A. E., & Koller, P. C. Genetical and cytological studies of the inter- generic hybrid of Cairina moschata and Anas platyrhyncha platyrhyncha. Proc. R. Soc. Edinburgh, 1935-36, 56: 210-41, 4 pi—Carlington, C. D. Chromosome behaviour and struc- tural hybridity in the Tradescantiae. J. Genet., Lond., 1929-30, 21: 207-86.—Diirken, B. Ueber die Keimdriisen und dieChromosomen der Artbastarde Rana arvalis Nils. 9 Rana fusca Ros. cf Zschr. indukt. Abstamm., 1937-38, 74: 331-52.—Federley, H. Chromosomenanalyse der reziproken Bastarde zwischen Pygaera pigra und P. curtula sowie ihrer Ruckkreuzungsbastarde. Zschr. Zellforsch. mikr. Anat., HYBRID 1)12 HYBRID 1930-31, 12: 772-816.—Gates, R. R.. & Sheffield, F. M. L. Chromosome linkage in certain Oenothera hybrids. Philos. Tr. R. Soc. London, 1929, ser. B, 217: 367-94, 3 pl—Ghigi. A. Geni e ormoni negli ibridi fra alcune specie di Gennaeus (fngiani argentati) Rendic Accad. sc. Bologna, 1932-33, 37: 172-80, 3 pl.—Hakansson, A. Die Chromosomen in der Kreuzung Salix viminalis x caprea von Meribert Nilsson. Hereditas, Lund. 1929, 13: 1 -52, pl. ------ Zur Zytologie von Godetia- Arten und -Bn-t,arden. Ibid., 1941, 27: 319-36.—Irwin, M. R.. A Cole, b. J. Further studies of the interrelationships nf cellular characters in Columbidae. Genetics, 1940, 25: 326-36.— Kattermann, G. Chromosomenuntersuchungen bei halmbebaarten Stammen aus Weizenroggenbastardierung. Zschr. indukt. Abstamm., 1937, 73: 1-48. ------ Das Verhalten des Chormosoms fiir Behaarung roggenbehaarter Na'hkcmmen aus Weizenroggenbastardierung in neuen Kreuzungen mit Roggen und Weizen. Ibid., 1937-38, 74: 1-16 —Krug, ('. A., & Mendes, A. J. T. Cytological observa- tions in Coffea. J. Genet., Cambr., 1939-40, 39: 1S8-203.— Love, R. M. Chromosome number and behaviour in a plant breeder's sample of pentaploid wheat hybrid derivatives. Canad. J. Res., 1940, 18: Sect. C, 415-34, pl. ------ Chromo- some behaviour in Fi wheat hybrids; pentaploids. Ibid., 1941, 19: Sect. C, 351-69, pl.—MacKnight, R. H. Crossing over in the sex chromosome of racial hybrids of Drosophila pseudo- obscura. Genetics, 1937, 22: 249-56—Miintzing, A. [Chro- mosome fragmentation in a Crepis hybrid] Hereditas, Lund., 1934, 19: 284-302.—Nawaschin, M. Ueber die Veranderung von Zahl und Form der Chromosomen infolge der Hybridisa- tion. Zschr. Zellforsch., 1927, 6: 195-233.—Oelkrug, K. Genetische und zytologische Untersuchungen an Eu-Oeno- theren; die Zytologie der Komplexverbindungen zwischen Oe. berteriana und Oe. mollissima und die Frage der Homozygoten- Eliminierung bei den Eu-Oenotheren Zschr. indukt. Abstamm.. 1934, 68: 22-93.—Peto, F. H. Hybridization of Triticum and \<_'in|>yron; cytologv of the male parents and F generation. ( anad. J. Res., 1936, 14: Sec. C, No. 5, 203-14, 2 pl.—Ralston, E. M. A study of the chromosomes of hybrids, with special icference to hybrids of Platypoecilus maculatus and Xipho- Dlmms helleri. In Summaries Doet. Diss. Northwestern lniv.. 1937, 5: 275-82.—Riley, H. P. Chromosomal behavior in 2 natural Tradescantia triploid hybrids with centric frag- ments. Genetics, 1942, 27: 165.—Rosenberg. <). Cytological investigations in plant hybrids. Rep. Internat. Conf. Genet. (1906) 1907, 3. Conf., 289-91.—Showalter, A. M. Studies in the cytology of the Anacrogynae; hybrid fertilization in Riccardia pinguis. Cellule, Lierre, 1928, 38: pt 3, 293-349, 6 pl.—Sikka, S. M. A study of chromosome catenation in Oenothera hybrids. J. Genet., Cambr., 1939-40, 39: 309-34.— Simonet, M. Nouvelles recherches sur le nombre des chromo- somes chez les hybrides des iris des jardins (Iris germanica Hort.l C. rend. Acad, sc, 1929, 188: 82-4. ■-----; Con- jugaison autosyndetique des chromosomes k la meiose de quelques hybrides interspecifiques d'lris. Bull, biol., Par., 1935, 49: 178-212, pl.—Spier, J. D. Chiasma frequency in species and species hybrids of avena. Canad. J. Res., 1934, 11: 347-61.—Tan, C. C. Genetic maps of the autosomes in Droso- phila pseudoobscura. Genetics, 1936, 21: 796-807.—Tchou-Su. Etude cytologique sur l'hvbridation chez les anoures. Arch. anat, micr., Par., 1931, 27: 1-105, 11 pl.—Thompson, W. P. Chromosome behaviour in triploid wheat hybrids. J. Genet,, Lond., 1926-27, 17: 43-8. ------& Cameron, D. R. Chromo- some numbers in functioning germ cells of species-hybrids in wheat. Genetics, 1928, 13: 456-69.—Thompson, W. P., & Hollingshead, L. Preponderance of dicoccum-like characters and chromosome numbers in hybrids between Triticum dicoc- cum and Triticum vulgare. J. Genet., Lond., 1926-27, 17: 283-307. ---- Development. Boehringer, F. Ueber die Kernverhaltnisse und die Ent- wicklung der merogonischen Amphibienbastard Triton (9) x Salamandra cf. Arch. Entwmech., 1938, 138: 376-422 — Brink, R. A. Studies on pollen tube development in a partially sterile hybrid between Linaria vulgaris and L. purpurea. Zschr. indukt. Abstamm., 1927- 44: 129-48.—Hamburger, V. The larval development of reciprocal species hybrids of Triton taeniatus, Leyd. (and Triton palmatus, Duges) x Triton crista- tus, Laur. J. Exp. Zool., 1936, 73: 319-73, 4 pl.—Jones, D. F. Chromosome degeneration in relation to growth and hybrid vigor. Proc. Nat. Acad. Sc. U. S., 1942, 28: 38-44.—Leding- ham, G. F. Cytological and developmental studies of hybrids between Medicago sativa and a diploid form of M. falcata. Genetics, 1940, 25: 1-15.—McCray, F. A. Embryo develop- ment in Nicotiana species hybrids. Ibid., 1933, 18: 95-110.— Marshak, A. Growth differences in reciprocal hybrids and cytoplasmic influence on growth in mice. J. Exp. Zool., 1935-36. 72: 497-510.—Moore, J. A. Developmental rate of hybrids between Rana pipiens and Rana sphenocephala. Proc. Soc. Exp. Biol., N. Y., 1941, 47: 207-10. ■---— Develop- mental rate of hybrid frogs. J. Exp. Zool., 1941, 86: 405-22 — Pinney, E. Developmental factors in teleost Iiybrids; the early mitotic behavior in the cross between Menidia menidia notata 9 and Prionotus carolinus cf. J. Morph., 1928, 45: 579-92, 3 pl.—Reverberi, G. Analisi dei primi momenti dello sviluppo in uova ibride di Ascidie. Pubb. Staz. zool. Napoli, 1935-36, 15: 175-93.—Skalineka, M. Developpement seiectif de tvpes dans la descendance d'un hvbride triploide d'Aquilegia. C. rend. Soc. biol., 1934, 117: 785-8.—Skowron, S. Sur le developpement .le- hybrides de tel6osteens. Ibid., 1926. !i.">: 971-3.—Tirelli. M. Studi su alcuni fenonieni fisiologici n.ll< uova ibride del Mombyx mori L. Zool. Jahrb. Abt, allg. Zool., 1933-34. 53: 367-410. ---- Fecundity and sterility. Bataillon. E., & Trhcrniakofsky, P. Stcrilite des hybrides males is-us du crois^ement entre Mol^e ninrmorata et Molgc cristata. C. rend. Acad, sc., i20' %V 201-—teiehtentrltt. Lengsfeld & rtK?6 n- 89; 145.—Rylov, W. M. Anleitung zur Unler.su'.-hun"' des Limnoneustons. In Handb. biol. Arbeitsmeth. (AhderluTldent Berl., 1936, 9: pt 2, 1385-418.—Shclford, V. E. Die Mcssuni des Eindnngens von Licht in Wasser mit photoclcHrischpn Zellen. Ibid., 1495-524. ------ & Eddy, S. Methoden zur Untersuchung von Flusslebensgemeinschaften. Ibid. 1525- 49.—TJtermohl, H. Quantitative Methoden zur Untersuchune des Nannoplanktons. Ibid., 1879-937.—Van Harreveld A A physiological solution for freshwater crustaceans Proc' Soc Exp. Biol., N. Y., 1936, 34: 428-32.—Wagler, E Die chemische und physikalische Untersuchung der Gewasser fur biologische Zwecke. In Handb. biol. Arbeitsmeth (Abder- halden) Berl., 1925, Abt. 9, Teil 2, 1-72.—Wasmund, E. Tech- nik der Unterwasserbohrung auf Bohrfiihren. Ibid., 1936, 9: pt 2, 1839—78. HYDROCARBON. See also proper names of hydrocarbons Ellis C & Wells, A. A. Hydrocarbons. In their Chem. Action UV Rays, rev. ed., N. Y., 1941, 466-9.—Friedel & Ladenburg. Sopra un nuovo idrocarburo. Gior farm chim Tor 1867, 16: 22-9.-Lehmann, K. B., & Flury, F. Gechlorte Kohlenwasserstoffe. In Toxikol. & Hyg. techn. Losungsmittel (KB. Lehmann, & F. Flury) Berl., 1938, 100-47.—Levene, P. A., & Marker R E. Hydrocarbons derived from methvl- ?«fny!™ai!o etnytohenylacetic acids. J. Biol. Chem., 1935 J?8- 409-18. Also repr.—Mikeska, L. A., Smith, C. F, & Lieber, E. High-molecular-weight hydrocarbons and hydro- carbon intermediates. J. Org. Chem., 1937-38 2: 499-505 — Ne£iS,h\P" Kimura> P- & Kamiike, O. Hydrocarbons from carbide thermodynamics. Rev. Phys. Chem. Japan 1941 15- 31-?1.—RoflTo, A. H. Sobre la existencia de hidrocarburos eri ?Cairoo7eo?'7C1Uia.d- uBOt't Ins^' Vn,ed- exP" Ci5ncer' B- A'r- 1939, w-i * ffu-"Saut' ?•„ Kohlenwasserstoffe. In Fortsch. Heilstoffchem. (Houben) 2. Abt., 2: 1-116. ---- aliphatic. Nast, H. A. *Ueber die Reaktionsfahigkeit ungesattigter und gesiittigter Kohlenwasserstoffe ?oo-7 ttreihe [Jena] 51p- 8? Borna-Lpz., Andreev, D. N. [Action of slow discharges on hydrocarbons of the aliphatic series] Pnroda, Leningrad, 1937, 26: 14-24 — iHf'JI'k ',& G?rdner- J- B- Comparative studies of the slow combustion of methane, methyl alcohol, formaldehyde, 9Q"d q98miCr,aCld- . Pr^' ?• Soc- Lond- 1936. ser. A. 154; 297-328—Deanesly, R. M., & Carleton, L. T. Physical constants of the normal paraffin hydrocarbons. J. J'hvs. Chem., 1941 45: 1104-23-Duveen, D., & Kenyon, J. Con- tributionk 1 etude des hydrocarbures aliphatiqucs optique- ment actifs; quelques experiences pr6Uminaires. Bull. Soc. chirn. France 1938, 5. ser 5: 1120-6.-Egloff. G., & Kuder, k I Jt •V0,m™e relationships among aliphatic hydro- carbons at their boibng points. J. Phys. Chem., 1941, 45: *VL • ~T7-— Ipemolal volumes of aUphatic hydrocarbons at their melting points. Ibid., 1942, 46: 296-304.—Egloff, G.. Schaad R. E & Lowry, C. D. jr. Decomposition and poly- eoSn?11 g,f,tIjP olefimc hydrocarbons. Ibid., 1931, 35: 1825-903 —Egloff, G., Sherman, J., & Dull, R. B. Boiling PqIc\ a\elationships among aliphatic hydrocarbons. Ibid., 1940 44: 730^-45.—Foresti, B. Influenza del pH sulla velocity dell idrogenazione catalitica di alcune define. Boll. Soc. eustach., 1940, 38: 17-27.—Fr6ling, E.. & Laflltte, P Sur I inflammation spontanee des melanges d'hexane normal et ma'r- ^C>5en^Acad- sc- 1939' 208: 1905-7.—Henze, H. K-. k Blair, G.M. I he number of structurally isomeric hydrocarbons of the ethylene series. J. Am. Chem. Soc, 1933, 55: 680-6 — mT'oM110^ of paraffin hydrocarbons. J. Franklin Inst., M2 233: 75.—Levene, P. A., & Marker, R. E. Configura- tionul relationship of hydrocarbons; the optical rotations of the HYDROCARBON 919 HYDROCARBON hydrocarbons of the series methylisobutylmethane. J. Biol. Chem., 1931, 92: 455-60. Also repr. ------ Optically active methane derivatives containing propyl, isopropyl, isobutyl, isoamyl, and isohexyl groups. Ibid., 91: 405-18. Also repr. .----- Optical rotations of hydrocarbons of the isoamyl series; the qonfigurational relationship of substituted carbonic acids containing an isobutyl and an isoamyl group to those of the corresponding normal carbonic acids. Ibid., 1932, 95: 1-24. Also repr.—Merezhkovsky, B. K. [Oxidation of methyl croups in non-saturated compounds with open chain] J. Russ. fiz. khim. obshch., khim. ch., 1914, 46: 1244-50— Miller, W. T. The action of fluorine upon some simple aliphatic chlorinated hydrocarbons. J. Am. Chem. Soc, 1940, 62: 341-4.—Newitt, D. M., & Gardner, J. B. The initial formation of alcohols during the slow combustion of methane and ethane at atmos- pheric pressure. Proc. R. Soc, Lond., 1936, ser. A, 154: 329-35.—Oskerko, A. [Obtainment of hexatriacontane C36H74.] J. Russ. fiz. khim. obshch., khim. ch., 1914, 46: 416.—Reid, E. W. The pyrogenic decomopsition of ethan^ and propane. Abstr. Theses Univ. Pittsburgh, 1931, 7: 165- 73.—Roper, E. E. Gas imperfection; thermodynamic quanti- ties for some unsaturated aUphatic hydrocarbons derived from the equations of state. J. Phys. Chem., 1941, 45: 321-8.— Rust, F. F., & Vaughan, W. E. The high-temperature chlorina- tion of olefin hydrocarbons. J. Org. Chem., 1940, 5: 472- 503.—Schmerling, L., Friedman, B. S., & Ipatieff, V. N. Notes on the preparation and properties of some aliphatic hydrocarbons. J. Am. Chem. Soc, 1940, 62: 2446-9.— Shomate, C. H. The free energies of formation in the gaseous state of 3 olefin hydrocarbons and isopropyl alcohol. Abstr. Diss. Stanford Univ. (1939-40) 1940, 15: 111-4.—Vaughan, W. E., & RiJst, F. F. The high-temperature chlorination of paraffin hydrocarbons. J. Org. Chem., 1940, 5: 449-71. ---- Biology. Bushnell, L. D., & Haas, H. F. The utiUzation of certain hydrocarbons by microorganisms. J. Bact., Bait., 1941, 41: 653-73— Haddow. A., Scott, C. M., & Scott, J. D. The influence of certain carcinogenic and other hydrocarbons on body growth- in the rat. Proc. R. Soc, Lond., 1937, 122: ser. B, 477-507.—Johnson, F. H., Goodale, W. T., & Turke- vich, J. The bacterial oxidation of hydrocarbons. J. Cellul. Physiol., 1942, 19: 163-72.—Morel, A., Rochaix, A., & Mathias, C. Recherches sur les pouvoirs infertiUsant et antiseptique de quelques hydrocarbures vis-i-vis des cultures de certains microbes pathogenes. C. rend. Soc. biol., 1931, 108: 897-9.— Rostovtsev, P. J. [Hydrocarbons and functions of the body] J. Physiol. USSR, 1936, 21: 975.—Strawinski, R. J., & Stone, R W The utiUzation of hydrocarbons by bacteria. J. Bact., Bait., 1942, 43: 18.—Tennent, D. H., & Russell, M. A. The effect of polymerized hydrocarbons on the cells of tissue cul- tures. Arch. exp. Zellforsch., 1930, 10: 205-11, 2 pl. ---- carcinogenic. See also Cancer, experimental: Carcinogenic agents. „ „ ^ ». Bachmann, W. E., Kennaway, E. L., & Kennaway, N. M. The rapid production of tumours by 2 new hydrocarbons, Yale J. Biol., 1938-39, 11: 97-102, pl—Barry, G Cook, J. W. Tet al 1 The "production of cancer by pure hydrocarbons. Proc R Soc, Lond., 1935, ser. B, 117: 318-51, 2 pl.—Beltrami, W Azione organismica generale di ldrocarbun sintetici cancerogeni. Tumori, Milano, 1935, 21: 537-46.—Bonser G. M & Orr J W. The morphology of 160 tumours induced by carcinogenic hydrocarbons in the subcutaneous tissues of mice. J. Path. Bact.,. Lond., 1939, 49: 171-83, 6 pl.-Bruce. W. F. Carcinogenic hydrocarbons; the bromination 'of hydnndene and a briefer synthesis of cholanthrene J. Am. Chem. Soc, 1941 63- 301-3 ■------ Carcinogenic hydrocarbons; a com- parison of the fluorescence intensity of cholanthrene and certain of its homologs. Ibid., 304.—Bryan, W. R & Shimkin M. B Quantitative analysis of dose-response data obtained with carcinogenic hydrocarbons. J. Nat. Cancer Inst., 1940-41, 1. 807-33—Carmlnati, V. Sulla presunta azione estrogena deU'idrocarburo cancerogeno 1-2 ber.zo-pirene T'imori Milano, 1935, 21: 106-14-Chalmers, J. G The exaction and fluorescence analysis of some carcinogenic aromatic hydro- carbons Commun. Internat. Congr. Sc Campaign Cancer (193611937 2 Con<*r 2-4.—Creech, E. M. H. Carcinogenic ind "related non-carcinogenic hydrocarbons in tissue culture. Am. J. Cancer, 1939, 35: 191-202.—Davis, W. W., Krah M. E., & Clowes, G. H. A. Solubility of carcinogenic and related hvdrocarbons in water. J. Am. Chem. Soc, 1942, 64. 108- 10y-Duran-Rey„a.s, F. A note on the action of some^cino- eenic hvdrocarbons on amphibia. Yale J. Biol., 19.5S-.i9, 11. l^_C7.-Go.dstein, S. A microbiological test for carcmogenic hydrocarbons. Science, 1937 86: 176.-Graffi, A Ze™? Speicherung cancerogener Kohlenwasserstoffe. .^chr. Krebe forsch., 1939, 49: 477-95.-Growth-inhib.tory (The action ot the carcinogenic hydrocarbons. Annual Rep Brit Empire Cancer Camnaien 1939, 16: 300-2.—Haddow, A. lhegrowtn- SwbftingTroperties of carcinogenic hydrocarbons in relation, to their mode of action. Commun. Internat Congr. Sc Campaign Cancer (1936) 1937, 2. Congr., 23.—Hearne, E. M. inaucea ?Masma(fo?mationin somaric cells by a carcinogenic hydro- carbon Nature Lond., 1936, 138: 291—Hocn-L,igeu, k,. Further experiments on the effect of carcinogenic hydrocarbons on the elimination of Congo red from the circulation Am J Cancer, 1940, 39: 365-76. ------ Studies on the changes iii the lymphoid tissue of mice treated with carcinogenic and noncarcinogenic hydrocarbons. Cancer Res., 1941, 1: 484-8.— I ball, J. Oxidation-reduction potentials of quinones derived from carcinogenic hydrocarbons. Am. J. Cancer, 1940, 38: 372-6.—Larionov, L. T., Ivashentsova, N. G., & Chertkova, M. A. Sur Taction des hydrocarbures canc6rig£nes dans les cultures des tissus. Bull. biol. med. exp. URSS, 1938, 6: 113-7.— LeRoy, G. V., Kandel, E. V., & Brunschwig, A. Observations on the intravenous administration of colloidal solutions of carcino- genic hydrocarbons in rabbits. Am. J. Cancer, 1938, 32: 449- 52.—Lorenz, E., & Andervont, H. B. Note on the preparation of dispersions of carcinogenic hydrocarbons in serum. Ibid., 1936, 26: 783-6.—Lorenz, E., & Stewart, H. L. Intestinal carcinoma and other lesions in mice foUowing oral administra- tion of 1, 2, 5, 6-dibenzanthracene and 20-methvlcholanthrene. J. Nat. Cancer Inst., 1940, 1: 17-40, 5 pl. Also repr.—Morelli, E., & Dansi, A. Contributo alio studio del meccanismo di azione di alcuni idrocarburi cancerogeni. Commun. Internat. Congr. Sc. Campaign Cancer (1936) 1937, 2. Congr., 8-11 — Morton, A. A., Branch, C. F., & Clapp, D. B. The production of cancer by hydrocarbons other than those of the phenanthrene type. Am. J. Cancer, 1936, 26: 754-60.—Orr, J. W. An investigation of the histological changes in the subcutaneous tissues of mice during the induction of sarcoma by carcinogenic hydrocarbons. J. Path. Bact., Lond., 1939, 49: 157-70, 8 pl.— Rondoni, P., & Beltrami, W. Influenza dei tumori da idro- carubri suUa crescita di trapianti di tumori pure indotti da idrocarburi. Tumori, Milano, 1939, 25: 585-601.—Rusch, H. P., & Kline, B. E. The inhibition of phospholipid oxidation by carcinogenic and related compounds. Cancer Res., 1941, 1: 465-72.—Schmidt, O. Ueber Dichteverteilung der B- Elektronen; die Charakterisierung der einfachen und krebs- erzeugenden aromatischen Kohlenwasserstoffe durch die Dichteverteilung bestimmter Valenzelektronen (B-Elektronen) Zschr. phys. Chem., Abt. B, 1939, 42:83-110. ------ Charak- terisierung und Mechanismus der krebs-erzeugenden Kohlen- wasserstoffe. Naturwissenschaften, 1941, 29: 146-50.— Schurch, O., & Winterstein, A. Ueber die krebserregende Wirkung aromatischer Kohlenwasserstoffe. Zschr. physiol. Chem., 1935, 236: 79-91, 2 pl—Shear, M. J. Studies in carcinogenesis; development of Uver tumors in pure strain mice following the injection of 2-amino-5-azotoluene. Am. J. Cancer, 1937, 29: 269-84. ------ & Leiter, J. Tumor production in mice by low doses of carcinogenic hydrocarbons. J. Biol. Chem., 1941, 140: Proc, 115.—Shear, M. J., Stewart, H. L., & Seligman, A. M. Studies in carcinogenesis; tumors of the spleen and Uver in mice following the introduction of hydro- carbons into these organs. J. Nat. Cancer Inst., 1940, 1: 291- 302.—Shimkin, M. B., & Andervont, H. B. Comparative carcinogenicity of 3 carcinogenic hydrocarbons. Ibid., 57-62.— Twort, J. M., & Twort, C. C. Comparative activity of some carcinogenic hydrocarbons. Am. J. Cancer, 1939, 35: 80-5.— Voroniansky, G. S., Pisareva, T. A., & Sorin, I. E. [Histologi- cal aspect of tumors, caused by synthetic cancerogenous hydro- carbons of Soviet manufacture (dibenzpyrene and hydrodi- benzpyrene)] Arkh. biol. nauk, 1939, 55: No. 2, 89-97.— Wasley, W. L., & Rusch, H. P. Inhibition of the autoxidation of aldehydes by carcinogenic chemicals and related compounds. Cancer Res., 1942, 2: 422-4.—White, A., & White, J. The effect of single intraperitoneal injections of certain carcinogenic and non-carcinogenic hvdrocarbons on the growth of the rat. Yale J. Biol., 1939-40, 12: 427-31.—Wood, J. L., & Fieser, L. F. Thiocyanation of carcinogenic hydrocrabons. J. Am. Chem. Soc, 1941, 63: 2323-31. ---- Chemistry and physics. Pfafp, E. *Ueber eine neue Chlorbestim- mung in organischen, gechlorten Kohlenwasser- stoffen [Wurzburg] 7p. 8? Arnstein, 1930. Adamczewski, I. MobiUtes des ions dans la sirie des carbures d'hydrog^ne liquides et leur rapport avec le coefficient de viscosite. Ann. phys., Par., 1937, 11. ser., 8: 309-59 — Baine, J. O. The preparation of metalhc derivatives of certain aliphatic and aromatic hydrocarbons; benzyllithium, benzyl- sodium, benzvlpotassium and others. Yearb. Am. Philos. Soc. (1940) 1941, 110.—Bent, H. E., Dorfman, M., & Bruce, W. F. The electron affinity of free radicals; compounds not aromatic hydrocarbons. J. Am. Chem. Soc, 1932, 54: 3250-8.— Berthelot, C. L'hydrog6nation des charbons, du goudron primaire et des petroles. Nature, Par., 1934, 62: pt 1, 24-8.— Bone, W. A. The combustion of hydrocarbons. Proc. R. Soc, Lond., 1932, ser. A, 137: 243-74. ------ & Bell, J. The supposed intervention of steam in hydrocarbon combustion. Ibid., 1934, ser. A, 144: 257-66, pl.—Bone, W. A., & Outridge, L E. Some influences of dilution on the explosive combustion of hydrocarbons. Ibid., 1936, ser. A, 157: 234-48, 3 pl.— Boomer, E. H., Johnson, C. A., & Argue, G. H. EquiUbria in 2-phase, gas-liquid hydrocarbon systems; methods and appara- tus. Canad. J. Res., 1937, 15: 367-74.—Brown, W. G., Mighton, C. J., & Senkus, M. The Raman spectra of some hydrocarbons containing tertiary C-D linkages. J. Org. Chem., 1938 3:62-75.—Brutzcus, M. Sur la chaleur de formation des hydrocarbures. C. rend. Acad, sc, 1937, 204: 1802-4 — Bubnov, N. A. [Inner cone of hydrocarbon flame] J. Russ. fiz. khim. obschch., khim. ch., 1915, 47: 1191-211.—Burgoyne, HYDROCARBON 920 HYDROCARBON J. H., Tang, T. L., & Newitt, D. M. The combustion of aromatic and alicycUc hydrocarbons; ignition and cool-flame characteris- tics. Proc R." Soc, Lond., 1940, ser. A, 174: 379-94.—Carr, I". P., & Stiicklen, H. Die Absorptionsspcktren einiger Kohlen- wasserstoffverbindungcn im Schumann-Violett. Zschr. phys. Chem., Abt. B, 1934, 25: 57-70.—Day, R. A., jr, & Pease, R. N. Kinetics of oxidation of typical hydrocarbons. J. Am. Chem. Soc, 1941, 63: 912-5.—Dudley. H. C. A portable unit for the determination of halogenated hvdrocarbons. Pub. Health Rep., Wash., 1941, 56: 1021-7.—Egerton, A., & Pidgeon, L. M. Absorption spectra of burning hydrocarbons. Proc. R. Soc, Lond., 1933, ser. A, 142: 26-39, pl.—Euckcn, A., & Schafer, K. Riickschlusseausdenbisherigen Erfahrungen iiber diegehemmte Rotation der CH7-Gruppen in einfachen Kohlenwasserstoffen auf die gegenseitige Bindung der Atome. Naturwissenschaften, 1939, 27: 122-7.—Favorsky, A. [Atomic equiUbriums in particles of hydrocarbons of the CnHfn-2] J. Russ. fiz. khim. obshch., khim. ch., 1918, 50: 557-70.—Friberg, S. Ueber eine Gleichfbrmigkeit in der Dispersion fliissiger und gasformiger Kohlenwasserstoffe. Zschr. phys. Chem., Abt. B, 1934, 26: 195-202.—Govinda Rau, M. A. Hydrocarbon chemistry. Current Sc, Bangalore, 1941, 10: 38.—Griffith. R. H., & Plant, J. H. G. Catalysis in hydrocarbon chemistry; decomposition of low boiling hydrocarbons. Proc. R. Soc, Lond., 1935, ser. A, 148: 191-206.—Grosse, A. V., & Ipatieff, V. N. New metal halide catalysts for hydrocarbon reactions. J. Org. Chem., 1936-37, 1: 559-66.—Herold, W., & Wolf, K. L. Bedeutung der Struktur des Kohlenwasserstoffrestes fiir die Geschwindig- keit und Gleichgewichtslage bei organischen Umsetzungen. Zschr. phys. Chem., Abt. B, 1931, 12: 194-205.—Herouard. Note sur le degrg d'inflammabilit6 de quelques hydrocarbures. J. chim. med., Par., 1867, 5. ser., 3: 629-32.—Heuse, W. Molvolumen von Kohlenwasserstoffen und einigen anderen Verbindungen bei tiefer Temperatur. Zschr. "phys. Chem., Abt. A, 1930, 147: 266-74.—Huggins, M. L. Densities and refractive indices of unsaturated hydrocarbons. J. Am. Chem. Soc, 1941, 63: 916-20.—Isolation of hydrocarbons in kerosene fraction of petroleum. J. Franklin Inst., 1941, 232: 489.— Kane, G. P. The influence of nitrogen peroxide on the 2-stage ignition of hydrocarbons. Proc. R. Soc, Lond., ser. A, 1939, 171: 251-69.—Kassel, L. Thermodynamic function of hy- drocarbon gases from spectroscopic data. J. Am. Chem. Soc, 1933, 55: 1351-63.—Kinney, C. R. A system correlating molecular structure of organic compounds with their boiling points; the monohalogen derivatives of the various hydro- carbons. J. Org. Chem., 1942, 7: 111-6.—Kohn-Abrest. Recherche des derives halogenes des carbures d'hydrogSne. Echo mid. nord, 1934, 3. ser., 2: 231.—Kiichler, L. Chemie der Kohlenwasserstoffe; Bericht uber die Tagung der Faraday Society in London vom 17. bis 19. April 1939. Naturwissen- schaften, 1939, 27: 720-4.—Kynrh, G. J., & Penney, W. G. On the heat of sublimation of carbon and on some absorption bands of 3 mesomeric hvdrocarbons. Proc. R. Soc, Lond., 1941, ser. A, 179: 214-31.—Lamb, A. B., & Roper, E. E. The vapor pressures of certain unsaturated hydrocarbons. J. Am. Chem. Soc, 1940, 62: 806-14.—Lautie, R. Sur quelques constantes physiques de series de carbure d'hydrogSne; appUcation k l'analyse des essences d'aviation. Bull. Soc. chim. France, 1937, 5. ser., 4: 2071-6.—Lebeau, P., & Picon, M. Sur quelques hydrogenations par le sodammonium: carbures d'hydrog^ne. C. rend. Acad, sc, 1914, 159: 70-2.—Levene, P. A. The configurational relationships of the derivatives of methyl- benzyl- and methyl-phenethvl-, methvlheptyl- and methyl- octylacetic acids. J. Biol. Chem., 1935, 110: 323-8. Also repr. ------& Marker, R. E. Configurational relationship ol hydrocarbons; optical rotations of hydrocarbons of the isopropyl series. Ibid., 1933, 100: 769-73. Also repr.—Lind, S..C, & Glockler, G. The condensation of hydrocarbons by electrical discharge; comparison with condensation bv alpha rays. J, Am. Chem. Soc, 1930, 52: 4450-61.—Lind, S. C, & Schultze, G. R. The chemical effect of electrical discharge in gaseous hydrocarbons; the condensation of ethane, propane, butane, and propylene as a function of time, and comparison of rates of condensation of lower members of the paraffin, olefin, and acetylene series. J. Phys. Chem., 1938, 42: 547-58.—Maillard, A., & Friedrich, R. Sur les produits formes par combustion imcomplete des hydrocarbures liquides 16gers. C. rend. Acad. sc, 1937, 205: 673-5— Marvel, C. S., Dietz, F. C, & Copley, M. J. Hydrogen bonds involving the C-H link; the solubility of donor solutes in halogenated hvdrocarbons. J. Am. Chem, Soc, 1940, 62: 2273-5.—Maryott, A. A., Hobbs, M. E., & Gross, P. M. Bond moment additivity and the electric moment "f some halogenated hydrocarbons. Ibid., 1941, 63: 659-63.— Meyer. K. H., & Wyk, A. van der. Die Viskositat verdiinnter Lo.-ungen: Methodik und Messungen an Losungen von Kohlen- waoserstoffen. Kolloid Zschr., 1936, 76: 278-89.—Mikeska, L. A., & Cohen, C. A. High-molecular-weight hydrocarbons and hydrocarbon intermediates. J. Org. Chem., 1941, 6: 787- 94.—Moore, G. E. Thermodynamic data on some hydro- carbons and related compounds. Abstr. Diss. Stanford Univ. (1939-40.) 1940, 15: 99-101.—Noller, C. R., Grebe, W. E., & Knox, L. H. The reducing action of the Grignard reagent; hvdrocarbons formed during reduction. J. Am. Chem. Soc, 1932, 54: 4690-6.—Norrish, R. G. W. A theory of the com- bustion of hydrocarbons. Proc R. Soc, Lond., 1935, ser. A, 150:36-57. ----— & Reagh, J. D. The surface as a Umiting factor in the slow combustion of hvdrocarbons. Ibid.. 1940, ser. A, 176: 429-48. Plissof, A. K., & Maleeffa, E. Sur l'influence exercee par l'eau lors de I'oxydation des hydrocarbure k hauts poids moleculaires. Bull. Soc. chim. France, 1936, 5. ser., 3: 1281-90.—Ruedy, R. Specific heat and dissociation of simple hydrocarbons. Canad. J. Research, 1932, 7: 328-36.— Sherrill, M. L., Smith, M. K.. & Thompson, D. D. Derivatives of normal pentane and normal heptane; dipolo momenta of the bromoethoxy and the dibromo derivatives. J. Am. ("hem. Soc, 1934, 56: 011-4.—Tanasescu, I., & Macarovici, M. La sul- fonation des hydrocarbures arvliques, a froid. Bull. Soc. chim. f'ranee. 1938, 5. ser., 5: 1120 >). Tobbens, B. D. Portable combustion apparatus for field determinations of chlorinated hydrocarbons. J. Indust. Hyg., 1937, 19: 204-11.—Townsend, I). T. A., & Maccormac, M. The inflammation of hydrocarlxm- air mixtures. In Dangerous Gases (Inst. Petrol.) Lond., 1939, 137-01. — I'bbelohde, A. R. Investigations on the combustion of hydrocarbons; absorption spectra and chemical properties of intermediates. Proc. R. Soc, Lond., 1935, ser. A, 152: 378-402, 2 pl.—Vaidya, W. M. A spectroscopic investigation of hydro- carbon flames. Ibid., 1941, ser. A, 178: 356-69.—Veil, S. La chimie des hydrocarbures. Rev. sc. Par., 1940, 78: 245.— Wall, F. T., & McMillan, G. W. Infrared absorption studies of some hydrocarbons. J. Am. Chem. Soc, 1940, 62: 2225 7.— Waterman, N. Observations polarographiques des hvdro- carbones bien ou non carcinogenes. Acta brevia neerl., 1939, 9: 143-7. Also C. rend. Soc. biol., 1939, 130: 1115.—Whit- more, F. C, & Johnson, H. H., jr. The use of sulfuric acid in purifying saturated hydrocarbons; its action on 2, 2, 4-tri- methylpentane. J. Am. Chem. Soc, 1941, 63: 1481.—Wojcie- chowski. M. Some physical constants of new hydrocarbons and their structural isomers. Proc. Am. Acad. Art. Sc, 1938- 40, 73: 361-9. ----- cyclic. Allsopp, C. B. Refractive dispersion of organic compounds: cyclohexene and 1:3-cyclohexadiene. Proc. R. Soc, Lond., 1934, 143: ser. A, 618-30.— Bandow, F. Ueber die Absorptions- spektren organischer Stoffe in konzentrierter Schwefelsaure; Verbindungen mit kondensierten Kohlenstoffringen. Bio- chem. Zschr., 1939, 301: 37-57.—Bauer, S. H., & Reach, J. Y. The structures of methylenecyclobutane and hexamethyl- ethane. J. Am. Chem. Soc, 1942, 64: 1142-7.—Briegleb, G. Die Bedeutung nichtlokalisierter Bindungen ([p]-Elektronen- wolke) aromatischer Kohlenwasserstoffe bei deren Molo- kuiverbindungsbildung mit Dipolmolekiilen. Zschr. phys. Chem., Abt. B, 1935-36, 31: 58-78.—Burgoyne, J. H. The combustion of aromatic and alicyclic hydrocarbons; the slow combustion of benzene, toluene, etc. Proc. R. Soc, Lond., 1937, 161: ser. A, 48-67. ------ The combustion of aromatic and aUcycUc hydrocarbons; the ignition of aromatic hydro- carbons at high temperatures. Ibid., 1939, 171: ser. A, 421- 33.—Butz, L. W., & Joshel, L. M. The synthesis of condensed ring compounds; the dianhydride of a steradiene-6, 7, 11, 12- tetracarboxylic acid. J. Am. Chem. Soc, 1941, 63: 3344-7.— Egloflf, G., & Kuder, R. C. Studies of the physical properties of alicyclic hydrocarbons; molal volumes of monoalicycUc hydrocarbons at 20° C. J. Phys. Chem., 1942, 46: 281-95.— Eisenberg, F. Ueber spezifisch bakterizide Wirkungen; Wirkungen der aromatischen Kohlenwasserstoffe, der Phenole und Phenolate. Bull, internat. Acad, polon. sc, cl. mid., 1936, 451-66.—Forster, T. Die Lichtabsorption aromatischer Kohlenwasserstoffe. Zschr. phys. Chem., Abt. B, 1938, 41: 287-396.—Grosse, A. V., Mavity, J. M., & Ipatieff, V. N. Reactions of paraffins with aromatic hydrocarbons; various aromatic hydrocarbons and 2, 2, 4-trimethylpentane. J. Org. Chem., 1938-39, 3: 448-55.—Jones, R.N. The influence of restricted rotation on the absorption spectra of aryl substituted aromatic hydrocarbons. J. Am. Chem. Soc, 1941, 63: 1658- 61.—Joshel, L. M., & Butz, L. W. The synthesis of condensed ring compounds; the successful use of ethylene in the Diels- Alder reaction. Ibid., 3350. ------ & Feldman, J. The synthesis of condensed ring compounds; the dianhydride of a tetradecahydrochrysene-5, 6, 11, 12-tetracarboxylic acid and a homolog with an angular methyl group. Ibid., 3348.—Kleene, R. D., & Wheland, G. W. Position of 2 aUcycUc hydrocarbons in the acidity series. Ibid., 3321.—Lepin, A. I., & Reich, V. N. [Stereoisomerism of symmetrical diethyldiphenylethane] J. Russ. fiz. obshch., khim. ch., 1915, 47: 149-60.—Luszczak, A. Beitrage zur spektrographischen Untersuchung gewerbe- hygienisch wichtiger Stoffe (Benzol, Toluol, Xylol) Abh. Hyg., 1936, H. 21, 1-58.—Mayneord, W. V., & Roe, E. M. F. The ultra-violet absorption spectra of some complex aromatic hydrocarbons. Proc. R. Soc, Lond., 1935-36, 119: ser. B, 87.—Norris, J. F., & Arthur, P., jr. The condensation of esters with aromatic hydrocarbons by means of aluminum chloride. J. Am. Chem. Soc, 1940, 62: 874-7.—Price, W. C, & Walsh, A. D. The absorption spectra of the cyclic dienes in the vacuum ultra-violet. Proc. R. Soc, Lond., 1941, 179: ser. A, 201-14, pl.—Sosnovik, I. J. [On the chronic effect of aromatic hydro- carbons (benzol, xylol and toluol)] In Promyshl. toks. (Arnau- tov, G. D.) Moskva, 1934, 52-65.—West, H. D.. & Jefferson, N. C. The effect of aromatic hydrocarbons on the growth of young rats. J. Nutrit., 1942, 23: 425-30. ---- Metabolism. Barrett, H. M., Cunningham, J. G., & Johnston, J. H. A study of the fate in the organism of some chlorinated hydro- carbons. J. Indust. Hyg., 1939, 21: 479-90.—Brusilovskaia, A. I., & Staritsina, T. V. Verteilung gesattigter Kohlenwasser. HYDROCARBON 921 HYDROCARBON stoffe im Organismus. J. Physiol. USSR, 1935, 18: 940-4.— Cason, J.. & Fieser, L. F. Synthesis of 4', 8'-dihydroxy-l, 2, 5, 6-dibenzanthracene and its relation to products of metabolism of the hydrocarbon. J. Am. Chem. Soc, 1940, 62: 2681-7.— Chalmers, J. G., & Peacock, P. R. Further evidence regarding the elimination of certain polycyclic hydrocarbons from the animal body. Biochem. J., Lond., 1936, 33: 1242-8, pl. ------The excretion of derivatives of certain carcinogenic and noncarcinogenic hydrocarbons in fowl bile. Ibid., 1941, 35: 1276-82.—Harbitz, F., & Foiling, A. A peculiar deposition of a hydrocarbon in the Uver of cows. Vet. Bull., Lond., 1942, 12: 106.—Reggiani, M., Dansi, A., & Morelli, E. _ Ulteriori ricerche sul processo di eUminazione degli idrocarburi cancero- geni iniettati. Tumori, Milano, 1939, 25: 635-43.—Stroud, S. W. The metabolism of the parent compounds of some of the simpler synthetic oestrogenic hydrocarbons. J. Endoer., Oxf., 1940, 2: 55-62. .--- Pathological effect. Leroux, P. *Les lesions cutanees des hydro- carbures et de leurs principaux deriv6s. 79p. 25cm. Par., 1939. Also Concours mid., 1940, 62: 76. Loges, W. *Ueber Spatschadigungen bei Narkosen mit halogenhaltigen Kohlenwasser- stoffen in verschiedenen Dosierungsbereichen und bei wechselnder Einwirkungsdauer. 15p. 8? Lpz., 1935. Munder, K. H. *Ueber eine Leberschadigung durch hohere aromatische Kohlenwasserstoffe [Berlin] 20p. 23cm. Charlottenb., 1937. Oettingen, W. F. von. Toxicity and potential dangers of aliphatic and aromatic hydrocarbons; a critical review of the literature. 135p. 8? Wash., 1940. Bennett, G. A., Drinker, C. K., & Warren, M. F. Mor- phological changes in the livers of rats resulting from exposure to certain chlorinated hydrocarbons. J. Indust. Hyg., 1938, 20: 97-123, 8 pl.—Briullova, L. P. [Zur Frage nach der haemolyti- schen Wirkung der Kohlenwasserstoffe] J. Physiol. USSR, 1934, 17: 389-91.—Drinker, C. K., Warren, M. F., & Bennett, G. A. The problem of possible systemic effects from certain chlorinated hydrocarbons. J. Indust. Hyg., 1937, 19: 283- 311.—Duvoir. Les maladies professionnelles caus6es par la manipulation des hydrocarbures et de leurs principaux d6riv£s. Ann. med. lig., 1928, 8: 453-501.—Floret. Neuere Beobach- tungen iiber gewerbliche Schadigungen durch Kohlenwasser- stoffe. Zbl. Gewerbehyg., 1926, n. F., 3: 7-10. ------ Ge- werbUche Vergiftungen durch Kohlenwasserstoffe der aro- matischen und ahphatischen Reihe (gechlorte Kohlenwasser- stoffe) und ihre Verhiitung. Ibid., 1927, n. F., 4: 257; 369.— Greenburg, L., Mayers, M. R., & Smith, A. S. Systematic effects from exposure to certain chlorinated hydrocarbons. indust. Hyg., 1939, 18: 343-7. ------ The systemic effects resulting from exposure to certain chlorinated hydrocarbons. J. Indust. Hyg., 1939, 21: 29-38.—Hamilton, A. Industrial poisoning by compounds of the aromatic series. Ibid., 1919, 1: 200-12.—Langelez, A., Peremans, G., & Bastenier, H. Le contrSle hematologique des intoxications par les hydrocarbures volatils. Bruxelles med., 1939-40, 20: 430-41—Lazarew, N W Ueber die Giftirkeit verschiedener Kohlenwasserstotl- diimpfe. Arch. exp. Path., 1929, 143: 223-33^—Lehmann, K B , & Schmidt-Kehl, L. Die 13 wichtigsten Chlorkohlen- wasserstoffe der Fettreihe vom Standpunkt der Gewerbo- hygiene. Arch. Hyg., Munch., 1936, 116: 131-268.—Mayers, M. R. Effects upon the skin due to exposure to some chlorin- ated hydrocarbons. Indust. Hyg., 1938, 17: 358-61. & Silverberg. M. G. Skin conditions resulting from exposure to certain chlorinated hydrocarbons. J. Indust. Hyg 1938^ 20- 244-58—Neitzel, E. Chlorierte Kohlenwasserstoffe und die Entstehung von Phosgen bei ihrer technischen Verwendung. Gesundh. Ingenieur, 1928, 51: 561-4.—Oettingen, W. F. von The halogenated hydrocarbons: their toxicity and potential dangers. J. Indust. Hyg., 1937, 19: 349-448.-Schwander, P Ueber die Diffusion halogenisierter Kohlenwasserstoffe durch die Haut. Arch. Gewerbepath., 1936, 7: 109-16 —Sjwe, &. A Zur Frage nach den Symptomen bei akuter Vergiftung mit fliissigen Kohlenwasserstoffen der ahphatischen Reihe. Mschr Kinderh 1932, 55: 146-53.—Toxicity and potential dangers of aliphatic and aromatic hydrocarbons; a critical review of literature. Pub. Health Rep., Wash., 1940, 55: 1833. ---- Pharmacology. Junkenitz, N. *Ueber pathologisch-anato- mische Organveranderungen bei Katzen die mit gechlorten Kohlenwasserstoffen akut vergittet wurden (Methodik, Ergebnisse, Literatur) 39p. 8? Wiirzb., 1933. , . ,. Lazarus, F. *Neue Versuche uber di e quantitative Wirkung eingeatmeter Dampfe der Chlorkohlenwasserstoffe bei verbesserter Metho- dik. 17p. 8? Wiirzb., 1932. Schwarzweller, F. *Der Verlauf der Nar- kose mit gechlorten Kohlenwasserstoffen. 16n 8? Wurzb., 1935. Abreu, B. E. Unsaturated mono halogenated hydrocarbons as general anesthetic agents. Anesthesiology, 1941 2:393-7__ Burger, O. K. Die Baeyersche Theorie der Spannune und die 1 nielescne der Restvalenzen in Anwendung auf die Wirkungs- weise der Kohlenwasserstoffe in der Narkose. Schmerz 193*6- 37, 9: 190-7.—Engelhardt, W. E., & Estler, W. Versuche uber die akut narkotische Wirkung aliphatischer und aromati- scher Kohlenwasserstoffe; die Wirkung einmaliger Einatmung verschiedener Konzentrationen Benzin, Benzol, Toluol, Xylol auf Kaninchen und Katzen. Arch. Hyg., Miinch., 1935, 114: 249-60.—Estler, W. Die Wirkung wiederholter Einatmungen verschiedener Konzentrationen von Benzin, Benzol, Toluol und Xylol auf weisse Mause. Ibid., 261-71.—Kairiukstis, J. Kohlenwasserstofftherapie und ihre Anwendungsgebiet. Acta med. scand., 1933, 80: 175-82.—Larionow, L. T. Weitere Studien iiber die Wirkung der aromatischen Kohlenwasserstoffe und anderer Narkotika auf die Gewebekulturen. Arch, exp Zellforsch., 1936, 19: 16-32.—Marsh, D. F. Biochemorphology of the halo-olefin anesthetics. Univ. California Pub. Pharm., 1941, 2: 39-62.—Varangot, J. Action oestrogtoe et toxicite du dihydroxydiphSnyl hexane. Bull. Soc. gyn. obst. Paris. 1939,28:426. ---- polycyclic. Geyer, A. *Etude experimentale du methyl- cholanthrene et du benzopyrene. 72p. 13 pl. 24^cm. Bord., 1937. Bachmann, W. E., & Cole, W. The coupling of derivatives of polycyclic hydrocarbons with glycine. J. Org. Chem., 1939, 4: 60-7.—Berenblum, I. Note on a stable suspension of dibenzanthracene in water. Lancet, Lond., 1932, 2: 1107.— Bisceglie, V. L'azione oncogena degli idrocarburi policicUci; insorgenza di sarcomi da 1: 2 benzopirene. Riv. pat. sper., 1937, 19: 75-83.—Boyland, E., & Brues, A. M. The congenital action of dibenzcarbazoles. Proc R. Soc, Lond., 1937, 122: ser. B, 429-41, 4 pl.—Briegleb, G., & Kambeitz, J. Bindungs- energien der Molekiilverbindungen von Mono- und Diphenyl, Polyen- und Polyinkohlenwasserstoffen mit s-Trinitrobenzol und die physikalische Natur der Nebenvalenzkrafte. Zschr. phys. Chem., Abt. B, 1936, 32: 305-33.—Chalmers. J. G. The elimination of 3:4-benzpyrene and other polycyclic hydro- carbons from the mouse. Biochem. J., Lond., 1938, 32: 271-8, pl.—Clowes, H. G. A., Davis, W. W., & Krahl, M. E. Reactions of carcinogenic and related compounds with cellular constitu- ents; interactions of polycyclic hydrocarbons with cholesterol, (3-dihydrocholesterol, and ergosterol in surface films. Am. J. Cancer, 1939, 36: 98-109. Also repr.—Creech, H. J., & Jones, R. N. Conjugates synthesized from various proteins and the isocyanates of certain aromatic polynuclear hvdro- carbons. J. Am. Chem. Soc, 1941, 63: 1670-3.—Fieser. L. F. Carcinogenic activity, structure, and chemical reactivity of polynuclear aromatic hydrocarbons. Am. J. Cancer, 1938, 34: 37-124.—Haddow, A., & Robinson, A. M. The association of carcinogenicity and growth-inhibitory power in the poly- cyclic hydrocarbons and other substances. Proc. R. Soc, Lond., 1939, 127: ser. B, 277-87.—Hieger, T. The fluorescence spectrum of 3:4-benzpyrene. Am. J. Cancer, 1937, 29: 705- 14.—Nametkin, S. S. [Characteristics of bicycUc saturated hvdrocarbons] J. Russ. fiz. khim. obshch., khim. ch., 1915, 47: 405-9.—O'Hara, P. H.. & Pollia, J. A. Notes on the preparation of colloidal solutions of 1: 2: 5: 6- dibenzanthracene, retene, and similar hydrocarbons. Am. J. Cancer, 1937, 31: 493-4.—Peacock, P. R. The metabolism of certain polycyclic hydrocarbons and some factors influencing their carcinogenicity. Commun. Internat. Congr. Sc Campaign Cancer (1936) 1937, 2. Congr., 1.—Pullinger, B. D. The first effects on mouse skin of some polycyclic hydrocarbons. J. Path. Bact., Lond., 1940, 50: 463-7i, 2 pl—Tyson, J. T., & Finch, G. I. The electron diffraction investigation of some aromatic polycycUc hydrocarbons. Annual Rep. Brit. Empire Cancer Campaign, 1938, 15: 217-9.—Waddington, C. H., & Needham, D. M. Studies on the nature of the amphibian organization centre; induction by synthetic polycycUc hydrocarbons. Proc. R. Soc, Lond., 1935, 117: ser. B, 310-7.—Winterstein, A., & Schon, K. Fraktionierung und ReindarsteUung organischer Substanzen nach dem Prinzip der chromatographischen Ad- sorptionsanalyse; polycvclische aromatische Kohlenwasser- stoffe. Zschr. physiol. Chem., 1934, 230: 146-58. ---;— & Vetter, H. Fraktionierung und ReindarsteUung organischer Substanzen nach dem Prinzip der chromatographischen Ad- sorptionsanalyse; Anthracen, Chrysen, Pyren. Ibid., 158-69. HYDROCELE. See also Kidney; Scrotum. Baer, H. *Die Hydrozele im Kindesalter. 26p. 8? Berl., 1927. Chwalla, R. Einiges iiber Hydrokele und Vankokele. Zschr Urol., 1935, 29: 256-72.—DeWire, M. B. Hydrocele: report of a case. Urol. Cut. Rev., 1937, 41: 860.—Giordano, D. HYDROCELE 922 HYDROCELE Riflessioni su due casi di idrocele. Rinasc. mod., 1933, 10: '74-7 pl—Greene, I.. B. lUdrocele. In Cyclop. Med. Piersol-Bortz) Phila., 19 10. It: 991-6—Ladd. W. K., A- Gross, R E. Hydrocele. In their \bdoin. Surg. Infancy. Phila., 19-11, 307-70 Maingot, R. Il\ droccle and varicocele. In Post- grad Sum. (Mamgot, H.) N. V., 1936, 2: 3275-80—Rubiano Groot. H. Historia clinica de un caso de hidrocele. Colombia mid., 1940, 2: 135-9. ---- abdomino-scrotal. Charters, A. D. Abdominal hydrocele with record of 2 cases. Urit M J 1935, 1: 470-2.—Curtis, C. S. Abdominoscrotal >i\di<>rrlV "J Am. M. Ass., 1932, 99: 467.—Herrmann, S. F. VuiommoMioud hydrocele. Ibid., 1932, 98: 399-400 — Parson^ H H. Abdominoscrotal hydrocele; hour-glass hydro- cele. CaUfornia West. M., 1935, 42: 266.—Prather, G. C. Abdominoscrotal hydrocele; review of the literature and report of a case. N. England J. M., 1942, 226: 255-60.—Roller, C. S. \bdominoscrotal hydrocele; a brief discussion and report of a case J Am. M. Ass., 1934, 103: 671.—Tanzer, R. C. Abdom- inoscrotal hydrocele. J. Urol., Bait., 1935, 34: 447-52. ---- bilocular. Ferrari. R. C. Un caso de hidrocele bilocular gigante. Bol. Inst. clin. quir., B. Air., 1928, 4: 51-9.—Lakohti, B. Bilocular hydrocele simulating hernia and hydrocele. Ind. M. Gaz., 193° 67: 199.—Willan, R. J. Case of bilocular hydrocele. Newcastle M. J., 1922-23, 3: 20. ---- Complication. Belt. N. Calcified hydrocele. Med. Ann. District of Colum- bia 1937 6: 42.—Collins, J. D. Traumatic rupture of the tunica vaginalis in hydroceles. South. M. J., 1930, 23: 247- 51.- (o»k. H. F., k Hewson, G. F. Traumatic rupture of a hydrocele with report of a case. J. M. Soc. N. Jersey, 1942, 39: 142.— Herrero Rubio, P. Un caso de pustula maligna en un lactante de diecisiete dias de edad. Arch, espafi. pediat., 1933, 17: -105 -9.— Kirkham, C. J. E. The report of a case of calcified hydrocele simulating tumor. N. England J. M., 1933, 208: 869-72 - Kleinschmidt. Incareerierte Hydrocele des Samen- strangs Med. Khn., Heil.. 1926, 22: 1713.—Matheson, N. M. Bilateral calcification of hydrocele sacs. Brit. .1. Crol.. 1934, 6: 161 —Mikula, M. [Hydrocele and physiological phimosis in the newly born] Bratisl. lek. listy, 1929, 9: 544-51 .—Moses, C. D. Inguinal hernia and hydrocele. Hadiogr. Clin. Photogr., 1939, 15: 59.—Smirnoff, N. A. Zur Kasuistik seltener Falle von Hydrocele (Hydrocele bei Inversio testis) Zschr. Urol., 1928 22: 12-5 Toulson, W. H. The hvahnization of hydro- cele sa.s. .1. Urol.. Bait., 1932, 28: 217-50. Wright-Smith. R. J. Chronic infect'id hydrocele. J. Coll. Surgeons Australasia, 1928, 1: 249-57. ---- Diagnosis. Becker, E. Die Transparenzpriifung der Hydrokcle. Zbl. Chir., 1926, >3: 462.—Burton. R. H. Chronic hydrocele of the tunica vaginalis; its differential diagnosis and the late method of radical cme by inverting the sac. Los Angeles M. J., 1903-4, 1: rj-b. Delbet. P. Hydrocele Hie a des troubles urinaires d'origine pto-tatique; diagnostic et nature des hydroceles. Rev. g6n. clin. ther., 1932, 46: 802-5.— Federici, N. Dell'idrocele e della sua importanza. Med. prat.. Nap., 1926, 11: 375-8. -----— La nuova reazione di Lisbonne nella diagnosi di natura dell'idrocele. Policlinico, 1927. 34: sez. prat., 820-2.—Giacobbe, C. L'indagine radiografica nell idrocele. Gior. med. mil., 1930 78: 136-42.—Hartmann. Hydrocele. Rev. gin. clin. ther., 1928, 42: 691. ---- Etiology. Martin Fleury, J. De la nature tuberculeuse de certaines hydroceles dites essentielles. 58p. 8° Par., 1926. Martins, J. A. *Do hydrocele idiopathico. 47p. 8? Lisb., 1883. Aly Ibrahim. Relation of hydrocele to endemic funiculiti3. J. Egypt. M. Ass., 1935, 18: 661—Belloni, G. Lidrocele del lattante nei suoi rapporti colla infezione luetica e tubercolare. CUn. pediat., Mod., 1929, 11: 708-18— Biancalana, L. Sul- l'eziologia deU'idrocele essenziale. Atti Congr. naz. microb., 1931, 415-9. ------ & Botretti, M. Sur I'etiologie de l'hydro- cele essentiel. BoU. Sez. ital. Soc. internaz. microb., 1931, 3: 565-8.—Brindeau, Cartier. P., A- Pougin. De la nature tuber- culeuse de certaines hydrocele- congenitales. Bull. Acad, med.. Par., 1931, 3. ser., 105: 10:10-8.—Carbonara, G. Idrocele e sifiUde nei lattanti. Pediat. prat., Mod.. 1929, 6: 260-5.— Cicconardi, G. Sulla presunta natura tubercolare dell'idrocele essenziale. Riforma med., 1936, 52: 465-9.—Di Pace, I. L'idrocele nei lattanti eredoluetici. Xipiologia, Nap., 1927, 13: 21-''. — Epstein, I. M., & Efimov, I. I. [Pathogenesis of hydro- cele] Urologia, Moskva, 1932, 10: 31-5.—Hartmann. Hydro- cele congdnitale avec hernie. Rev. gin. clin. ther., 1926, 40: 789.—Lagos Garcia. A., & Olascoaga, M. L. Tratamiento del hidrocele vaginal idiopatico en la infancia. Prensa mid. argent., 1936, 23: 2349-54.—Pagliai, E. Contributo aUa patogenesi deU'idrocele comunicante. Arch. ital. chir., 1933, 33: 790-800.—Stenhouse. II, M. The significance of cholesterol in tropical hydrocele. Am. J. Trop. M., 1926, 6: 113-51.— Timossi, G. Contributo alio studio della patogenesi dell'idro- cele essenziale. Minerva med., Tor., 1928, 8: 107:i 7. ---- Fluid. Chopra, R. N., Ganguly, S. C, & Rao, S. S. Protein frac- tions and other physical properties of hydrocele fluid. Ind. .1, M. Res., 1941, 29: 253-7.—Guede. G. Sur un cas d'hvdinciMe hematique. Bull, med., Par., 1932. 46: 899.- l.ast. S. K. Hydrocele; clinical consideration and report of isolation of Diplococcus perflava in 1 case. Urol. Cut. Rev., 1940, 44: 720-7.—Lop. P. A. Hydrocele double k contenu chyliforme. Marseille med.. 1933, 70: 520. I'alumbo, E. Ricerche bat- teriologiche sulla vaginale propria del testicolo nell'idrocele idiopatico. Fol. med., Nap., 1932, 18: 1000. ---- Pathology. Balbin, R. Dos casos de hidrocele gigante. An. Hosp. S. Jose, Madr., 1932-33, 4: 249-53.—Cartier, P. !)<• la nature de certaines hydroceles dites essentielles. Bull. Acad, mid.. Par., 1931, 3. ser.. 105: 1034-6.—Georgescu, G., & Bijou, G. [Gigantic liydioccle and encysted inguinal hernial Spitalul, 1931, 41: 1.—-Macrae, D. E. A case of interstitial hydrocele. S. Barth. Hosp. .1.. bond., 1936, 44: 13-5.—Papp, G., k Steinert. G. [Hydrocele testis in inlants] Budapesti orv. ujs., 1934, 32: 7.—Pongratz, R. Hydrocele funicuU spermatid und einge- klemmte Hernie im Kindesalter. Kinderarztl. Prax., 1937, 8: 368-70.—Prima, C. Hydrocele funiculi spermatid. Zbl. Chir., 1927, .r>l: 1619.—Rives, J. D. Femoral hydrocele. Ann. Surg., 1931,99:989-92.—Schiele. Hydrocele encystica. Arch. klin. Chir., 1926, 141: 487-93.—Verkhratsky, S. A. [Hydrocele permagna] Vest, khir., 1938, 56: 114-6. ---- Surgery. Leifert, P. *TJeber die chirurgische Behand- lung der Hydrocele im Kindesalter [Leipzig] 14p. 8? Oschatz, 1926. Mikulla, E. *Die Winkelmannsche Operation als Behandlungsmethode der Hydrocele im Kindesalter [Munster] 18p. 8? Quakenbruck, 1931. Alam, M. An analysis of 336 cases of hydrocele and hema- tocele in which operation for radical cure was performed. Ind. M. Gaz., 1920, 5.r.: 408-10.—Avdeev, A. A. [Operative methods in hydrocele] Urologia, Moskva, 1939, 16: No. 3, 42.— Barbosa Vianna. Cura da hydrocele sem operacao cortante. Fol. med., Rio, 1924, 5: 25.—Bellini, G. B. Osservazioni sopra i metodi migliori, e piu recenti per la cura radicale deU'idrocele. Arch. sc. med. fis. toscane (1837-38) 1840, 1: pt 1, 683-8.— Cocci, G. L'operazione per idrocele. Prat, chir., Citta di Castello, 1926-27, 1: 53-9.—Dorfler, H. Ein Fall von Hoden- gangran im Anschluss an die Operation der Hydrokele nach Winkelmann. Zbl. Chir., 1928, 55: 853. Also in his Fiir Praxis, Miinch., 1938, 2: 147.—Esquerdo, A. Hidroceles operados por incisi6n antiseptica. Arch. ter. med. quir., Barcel., 1884-85, 3: 165; 182.—Gabay, A. Eine neue Modifikation der Operation bei Hydrocele testis (vorlaufige Mitteilung) Zbl. Chir., 1926, 53: 785.—Gala. 204-12.—Hachmeisfer. F. Hydrozelenbehandlung durch Claudeninjektion. Munch, med. Wschr., 1936, 83: 1474 — Hoch, G. F. Injection treatment of hydrocele. In Sclerosing therapy (F. C. Yeomans) Bait., 1939, 139-56— James, W L. Giant hydrocele successfully treated by the sclerosing method. Brit M J 1941, 2: 693—Keitzer, W. A. The injection treat- ment of cystic enlargements of the scrotum: hydrocele and spermatocele, Univ. Hosp. Bull., Ann Arb., 1936, 2. 6 — Kemble, A. The treatment of hydrocele and spermatocele bv injection. Urol Cut. Rev., 1935, 39: 862.-Kilbourne, n! J & Murray C J. Treatment of hydrocele; researches in new solutions for the injection treatment: results compared with operation; chmcal prize paper of the sixty-first annual session ?oqoe,Cahf«rnia Medical Association. California West. M hv din,- r TUgv E- S" TPatment of primary hydrocele xLr q? Ct22nnof /odium morrhuate. Pennsylvania M. J 1936-37, 40: 9.—Lubowe I. I. The treatment of hydrocele by the injection method. Med. Rec, N. Y. 1936 143- 490 — Luchetti, S. E., & d'Astek, E. H. Tratamiento de hidrocele esencial por el metodo de la aspiraci6n e inyeccion de liquidos modincadores. Prensa med. argent., 1937 24- 2158-62__ Maingot, R H. The technique of the injection treatment' of hydrocele. Postgrad. M. J., Lond., 1932, 8: 307.—Maraini B & Iacapraro, G. Tratamiento del hidrocele por la inyec'ci6n de bquidos modificadores. Actas Congr. amer. urol B Air 1937) 1939, 2. Congr., 2: 158-63. Also Accion med., B 'Air ' 1940, 10: 136-8.—Mayers, M. M. Treatment of hydrocele and similar scrotal cysts by the injection method, j Urol Bait 1937, 37: 308-18. ------• Treatment of hydrocele and similar cystic masses of the scrotum by the injection of sclerosing substances. Med. World, 1942, 60: 223-7.—Milbert, A. H. The injection therapy of hydrocele and spermatocele. 'Am J Surg., 1939, 44: 587-92.—Motz, C. Le traitement des hydro- celes vaginales et des kystes de l'epididyme par les injections de chlorhydrolactate double de quinine et d'uree. Pro«r med Par., 1935, 1914-9.—Porritt, A. E. The injection treatment of hydrocele, varicocele, bursae and naevi. Clin. J., Lond., 1931 B0: 355-8.—Pybus, F. C. The injection cure of hydrocele! Brit. M. J., 1930, 1: 239— Reaves. J. U. The present day treatment of hydrocele; with emphasis on the injection treat- ment. South. M. J., 1939, 32: 934-40.—Riva, R. de la. Ex- periencias sobre los hidroceles tratados por la esclero-puncion Rev. med. cubana, 1938, 49: 628-35.—Robertson, J. P. The treatment of large hydroceles by injection of sodium morrhuate. Am. J. Surg., 1941, 53: 421-7.—Rogge. H. Injection treat- ment of hydrocele with full strength carbolic acid. Urol. Cut. Rev., 1941, 45: 599 (Abstr.)—Roux, J. Cure ambulatoire et indolore de l'hydrocele par les injections sclerosantes. Praxis Bern, 1937, 26: 569— Solley, F. W. The injection treatment of hydrocele of the tunica vaginalis. Surg. CUn. N. America 1936, 16: 867-70.—Souza Neves, A. C. de. Traitement de l'hydrocele vaginale par une methode sclerosante. Paris med., 1938, 107: 219.—Tarsitano. A. Cura deU'idrocele con le iniezioni di cloridrolattato doppio di chinino e di urea. Mor- gagni, 1934, 76: 821.—Valerio, A. L'hydrocele vaginale. Paris med., 1934, 93: 521.—Weismann-Netter, R. La solution de quinine-uree comme agent de traitement des collections liquidiennes non suppur6es. Bull. Soc. med. hop. Paris, 1936, 3. ser., 52: 58-65. ---- Tunica vaginalis. Burlanesc, C. VaginaUte chronique sereuse (hydrocele calculeuse) J. urol. med., Par., 1927, 23: 124-6.—Campbell, M. F. Hydrocele of the tunica vaginalis; a study of 502 cases. Surg. Gyn. Obst., 1927, 45: 192-200—Chavannaz, G. Guerison spontanee dune trds volumineuse hydrocele vaginale durant les suites operatoires d'une hypertrophie prostatique traitee par voie haute. Bull. Soc. med. chir. Bordeaux (1921) 1922, 51.—Gosset, A. Hydrocele vasinale infantile. Progr. med., Par., 1937, 1725.—Hartmann. Hydrocele bilob6e de la tunique vaginale. Rev. gin. clin. ther., 1928, 42: 357.—Maron, V. Um caso de hydrocele vaginal simples numa creanca de oito annos. Ann. Soc. med. cir. Itabuna, 1938-39, 178, pl.— Romulo, E. P. Hydrocele of the tunica vaginaUs. Month. Bull. Bur. Health, Manila, 1936, 16: 52-60.—Thompson, A. R. Hydrocele of the tunica vaginalis: Guy's Hosp. Gaz., Lond., 1937, 51: 221; 237.—Torraca, L. II potere di assorbimento della tunica vaginale nell'idrocele. Arch. ita. chir., 1922-23, 6: 404-20. ---- in the female. Hilgenreiner, H. Ein Fall von Hydrocele feminina cruralis communicans. Zbl. Chir., 1933, 60: 2883-6.—Janik, A. [Female hydrocele (dilatation of canal of Nuck)] Polska gaz. lek., 1926, 5: 970.—Price, J. W., jr. Hydrocele muliebris; report of a case. Am. J. Surg., 1926, n. ser., 1: 30-2. Also repr—Ramachandra Rao, M. G. Hydrocele of Nuck. Anti- septic, Madr., 1929, 26: 50. HYDROCEPHALUS. See also Cerebrospinal fluid, Formation; Con- vulsive disorder; Encephalitis; Epilepsy; Menin- gitis; Otitis, etc. Grabner-Maraschin, G. *SuH'idrocefalo. 31p. 21cm. Padova, 1855. Marburg, O. Hydrocephalus; its sympto- matology, pathology, pathogenesis and treatment. 217p. 22cm. N. Y., 1940. Babonneix, L. A propos de l'hydrocephahe. Medecine, Par 1927-28 9:816-9.------ L'hydrocephahe chez l'enfant. Seni' hop. Paris, 1932, 8: 279.—Botto-Micca, A. 11 Tractatus de Hydrocephalo di Giovan Battista Cortesi. Pediat. med. HYDROCEPHALUS prat., Tor., 1933, 8: 372-87.—Bucy. P. C. Hydrocephalus. In Pract. Pediat. (Brennemann, J.) Hagerstown, 1937, 4: chap. 3, 28.—Davis, L. E. Hydrocephalus. In his Principles Neur. Surg., 2. ed., Phila., 1942, 438-42.—Heidrich. L. Der Hydro- cephalus. Erg. Chir., 1929. 22: 679T8;iO.—Iglesias, M. S; Breves consideraciones respcrto de la hidrocefalia. Rev. med. veracruz., 1932, 12: 44S 51.—-Johnson. E. W. Hydrocephalus. Minnesota M.. 1926, 9: -157-03.- Marburg. O. H vdrozephalus. Wien. klin. Wschr.. 193d, 43: 1038. Also J. Nerv. Ment. Dis., 1938,88:756-9.—Marfan, A. B. L'hydrocephalie. Nourrisson, 1928, 16: 12; 65.—Pierce, L. B. Hydrocephalus. Cyclop. Med. (Piersol-Bortz) Phila., 1939, 7: 319-29.—Symonds, C. P. Hydrocephalus. In Brit. Encycl. M. Pract. (Rolleston, H.) Lond., 1937, 6: 566-71, pl. ---- acute. Pauziskis, 0. *Ueber Hydrocephalus acutus, Meningitis serosa und Meningismus [Basel] 40p. 8? Mulhouse, 1929. Balado, M. Un caso de hidrocefalia aguda; cierre congenito, de los agujeros de Luschka y de Magendie. Arch, argent. neur., 1929, 4: 121-9, 8 pl. ------ Un caso de hidrocefalia aguda; cierre de la comunicaci6n de las cisternas cerebelo medulares con los restantes espacios aracnoideos. Ibid., 130- 40. ------& Bettinotti, S. Y. Hidrocefalia aguda por tumor medular. Ibid., 5: 28-32.—Bessau. Ueber akuten Hydro- zephalus. Deut. med. Wschr., 1926, 52: 1279.—Boschi, G., Serra, A., & Maccanti, A. Idrocefalo acuto curato col cate- terismo del terzo ventricolo attraverso il corpo calloso; guari- gione. Riforma med., 1929, 45: 737-9.—Vincent, C, & David, M. Hydrocephalic k developpement rapide par tumeur ependimaire obUterant le IV" ventricule; sur la valeur de la douleur occipitale et de l'attitude de la tete dans les tumeurs de la region. Rev. neur., Par., 1928, 35: pt 1, 568. ---- Casuistics. Ekke, K. *Beitrag zur Hydrocephalusstati- stik. 47p. 8? Kiel, 1934. Bernard, S. M. A case of hydrocephalus in a Malay Kam- pong. Malay. M. J., 1933, 8: 121.—Bettica, R. Sopra un caso storico di idrocefalo. Gazz. osp., 1939, 60: 155-7.— Gladstone, R. J., & Dunlop, H. A. A case of hydrocephalus in an infant, with comments on the secretion, circulation and absorption of the cerebro-spinal fluid. I. Anat., Lond., 1926- 27, 61: 387-413.—Hanes, F. M., Woodhall. B.. & Sprunt, D. Clinico-pathological conference. North Carolina M. J., 1941, 2: 382-4.-—Hassin, G. B. Hydrocephalus; report of a case in an infant with vestiges of a choroid plexus in the fourth ventricle only. Arch. Neur. Psychiat., Chic, 1932, 27: 406-19 — Hurowitz, J. Ueber einen ungewohnlichen FaU von Hydro- merenceplialie. Schweiz. Arch. Neur. Psychiat., 1936, 38: 207-38.—Kohno, M. Ueber den angeborenen Hirnbruch und t'\ stennieie, sowie einen Fall von Hydromemngoencephalocele occipitalis mit Cyslenniere. Nippon fujinkagakkai zassi, 1935, 30: 7.—Larue. G. H. Deux cas d'hydrocephahe. Bull. Soc. med. Quebec, 1935, 202-5.—Mariani, G. Rendiconto statistico sulla attiviti svolta dalla sezione anatomo-patologica durante il secondo e terzo semestre. Neopsichiatria, Pisa, 1936, 2: ■ 156-65.—Marta. A. Otto casi di idrocefalo; contributo clinico. Rass ostet., 1926, 35: 344-61.—Nadessin. Sur un cas d'hydro- cephahe. Rev. med. hyg. trop., Par., 1933, 25: 139.—Pichette, H., Brous3eau, A., & Morin, E. A propos d'un cas d'hydro- cephalie. BuU. Soc. med. hop. Quebec, 1932, 221-32.—Pierce, L. B. Acquired hydrocephalus; report of 2 cases occurring in adults. Am. J. Psychiat., 1.932, 12: 769-73, 3 pl.—Reinhart, H. L. Case record presenting cUnical problems; pathological diagnosis. Ohio M. J., 1940, 36: 633.—White, E. C. A case of acquired hydrocephalus. U. S. Nav. M. Bull., 1927, 25: 361-5, 2pl. ---- chronic. Heyser, K. F. *Ueber Missbildung des Sinus rectus bei einem Fall von Hydrocephalus internus chronicus [Leipzig] 48p. 8? Zeulen- roda, 1931. Tenxer, K. T. *Chronischer Hydrocephalus und Syringomyelic [Giessen] 13p. 21cm. Wertheim a. M., 1936. Aubry, M., Guillaume, J., & Thurel, R. Hydrocephalic chroniiiue chez un adulte par obUteration des trous de Luschka et Matrendie. Rev. neur., Par., 1934, 41: pt 2, 86-92.—Balado, M. Hidrocefalfa cr6nica por cierre de la cisterna cerebelo medular posterior. Arch, argent, neur., 1929, 4: 141-7.— Chavany, J. A. HydrocephaUe considerable parfaitement toieree pendant 30 ans; decompensation et evolution fatale en quelques mois. Presse med., 1939, 47: 1181.—Dal Prato, C. Un caso di idrocefalo cronico in adulto curato con il drenaggio ventricolare alia Krause. BuU. sc. med., Bologna, 1927, 10, ser., 5: 118-26.—Dott, N. M. Chronic hydrocephalus in a young subject. Edinburgh M. J., 1936, 43: No. 6, 74. ------ & Levin, E. Chronic progressive hydrocephalus. Ibid. [Tr. Med. Chir. Soc] 113-28—Fuller, C. K. Some observations on chronic hydrocephalus with report of a case apparently arrested. HYDROCEPHALUS Canad. M. Ass. J., 1927, 17: 675-7.—Heidrich. L. Zur Frage des Balkenstiches beim chronischen Hydrocephalus. Beitr klin. Chir., 1929, 147: 71-4.—Lange. C. de [Chronic hydro- cephalus; 5 cases] Ned. tschr. geneesk., 1929, 73: pt 1, 102-12. ------ Klinische und pathologisch-anatomische Mitteilungen iiber Hydrocephalus chronicus congenitus und aiaiuisitus Zschr. ges. Neur. Psychiat., 1929, 120: -133-500. Molinnri, L. Leptomeningite subacuta da meningococco di \\ eichselbaum in portatore di idrocefaUa cronica. Minerva med., Tor., 1933 24: pt 2, 618-21.—Northtield. D. W. C, & Russell. D. S. False diverticulum of a lateral ventricle causing hemiplegia in chronic internal hydrocephalus. Brain. Lond., 1939, 62: 311- 20.—Nuvoli, U. Dilatazione dei forami ottici e pseudodistru- zioni di parti ossee craniche da idrocefalo cronico. Ann. radiol., Bologna, 1934, 8: 19-32.—Pagani-Cesa, A. La ventricolo- grafia con liquidi opachi nell'idrocefalo cronico. Riv. cUn. pediat., 1936, 34: 123-33.—Paltrinieri, G. Roentgenterapia dell'idrocefalo cronico acquisito. Radiol, med., Milano, 1931, 18: 1595-613.—Reed, M. E. Chronic internal hydrocephalus- report of case. Med. Woman J., 1934, 41: 229-32.—Royle. N. D. Chronic hydrocephalus. Med. J. AustraUa, 1934, 1: 309. ---- Complication. Herold, K. [K. H.] *Hydrocephalie, Mikro- gnathie und Uranoschisma [Giessen] 8? Biele- feld, 1919. Lobe, N. *Ein Fall von geplatztem Hydro- cephalus als Versuch einer Selbstheilung bei Hydrocephalus internus permagnus [Berlin] 31p. Diisseld., 1938. Lutticken, M. M. A. *TJeber Encephalocele nasofrontalis mit Hydrocephalus. 23p. 8? Tub., 1935. Nannemann, H. *Hydrocephalus bei Dystro- phien [Kiel] 17p. 23j£cm. Quakenbruck, 1935. Apert & Cambesseiies. SyringomyeUe et hydrocephalic. Bull. Soc. pediat. Paris, 1919, 17: 169-74.—Balard & Le Demnat. Un cas d'hydroc6phalie avec anencephalie. J. med. Bordeaux, 1926, 56: 892.—Bhatia, B. B. Hydrocephalus associated with anaemia: recovery. Brit. M. .)., 1936, 1: 60.— Bottsford, L. L. Report of a case of hydrocephalus with spina bifida and complete situs inversus. Tr. Clin. Soc. Univ. Michigan, 1916, 7: 133-8.—Cantele, P. G. Studio anatomo- microscopico di malformazioni deU'orecehio in un caso di idrocefalo congenito con cheilo-gnato-urano-schisi laterale. Atti Soc. med. chir. Padova, 1933, ser. 2, 11: 949-58.—Castagna, P. Idrocefalo con aplasia dei genitali interni ed esterni, reni cistici, assenza del tenue e communicazione del colon nella vescica. Clin, ostet., 1927, 29: 79-82.—Di Maggio, F. Sin- drome di Little con idrocefalo dimostrato all'encefalografia. Minerva med., Tor., 1935, 26: pt 2, 448-50.—Garipuy & Gay. Hydroc6phalie et spina bifida. Bull. Soc. obst. gyn. Paris, 1923, 12: 617.—Linke, J. Ein hydrozephalisehes Monstrum pei defectum et per excessum. Med. Klin., Berl., 1911, 7: 138.—■ Penfield, W. Hydrocephalus and spina bifida. Surg. Gvn. Obst., 1935,60:363-9.—Pesme,P. Uncas d'hydrocephalieavec glaucome infantile. Arch, opht., Par., 193-1, 51: 524-31.— Rukstinat, G. Calcification of the dural and cerebral tissues in a hydrocephalic idiot child. Tr. Chicago Path. Soc, 1934, 14: 172.—Saba, V. Rara malformazione del Umbo corneale in soggetto ldrocefalico. Ann. ottalm., 1927, 55: 446-52, pl.— Vallois, L., Coll de Carrera & Chaptal. Un das d'hydrocephahe avec malformations viscerales multiples. Bull. Soc. obst. gyn. Paris, 1926, 15: 77-9. ---- congenital. Breidenbach, H. M. *Ein Fall von Hydro- cephalus congenitus internus chronicus mit beinahe vollstandigem Fehlen des Grosshirns. 64p. 8? Miinch., 1937. Finckh, H. *Klinische Erfahrungen iiber Hydrocephalus; die in der Universitats-Frauen- klinik Tubingen in den Jahren 1917 bis 1933 beobachteten Falle von Hydrocephalus con- genitus. 38p. 8? Tiib., 1938. Babonneix & Roueche. Hydrocephalic congenitale avec malformations. Bull. Soc. pediat. Paris, 1928, 26: 313-5.— Beaussart, P. HydrocephaUe congenitale partielle et hemi- paresie infantile; ramollissements et 6pilepsie tardive; hemor- ragies cerebrales et pedonculo-pontiques terminales. Bull. Soc. clin. med. ment., Par., 1921, 9: 281-4.—Brunetti, C. Encefalo- meningocele naso-frontale e idrocefalo congenito. Arch. ital. chir., 1927, 18: 56-62.—Clark, F. H. Anatomical basis of hereditary hydrocephalus in the house mouse. Anat. Rec, 1934, 58: 225-33.—Darr6, H., Mollaret, P. [et al.] Hydro- cephaUe congenitale par trypanosomiass hereditaire; demon- stration de la possibiUte du passage transplacentaire dans l'espece humaine. BuU. Soc. path, exot., Par., 1937, 30: 166- 76.—Fletcher. P. F. A discussion of congenital hydroceph- HYDROCEPHALUS 925 HYDROCEPHALUS alus: its diagnosis and treatment. Week. Bull. S. Louis M. Soc, 1935, 29: 453.—Folena, S. Su un particolare tipo di idrocefalo congenito; da ipertrofia dei plessi corioidei dei ventri- coU laterali. Riv. clin. pediat., 1940, 38: 93-106, 4 pl.— Fournier. HydrocephaUe et spina bifida; grippe au debut de la grossesse. Bull. Soc. obst. gyn. Paris, 1921, 10: 767.—Karn- mann, I. E. [Treatment of congenital hydrocephalus] Odessk. med. J., 1928, 3: 313-5.—Kovats, K. [Repeated occurrence of congenital hydrocephalus] Orv. hetil., 1940, 84: 531.—Kozlov, F. S. [Case of congenital hydrocephaly due to intra-uterine trauma] Sovet. pediat., 1935, No. 10, 125-8.—Lo Presti- Seminerio, F. Su di un caso di idrocefalo ed emorragia ombeU- cale in un neonate Pediatria (Riv.) 1926, 34: 43-5.—Meirelles, A. A questao da eutanasia e um caso de hidrocefaUa congenita progressiva. Pediat. prat., S. Paulo, 1932-33, 4: 457-60.— Parzy, P., & Declercq, G. Un cas d'hydroc6phaUe congenitale. J. sc. med. Lille, 1925, 43: pt 1, 114-6.—Robin, P. A. Congeni- tal hydrocephalus; report of 2 cases. Am. J. Roentg., 1941, 45: 862-5.—Shanahan, A. A. Congenital hydro-cephalus; ruptured. Eclect. M. J., 1936, 96: 383-5.—Wakeley, C. P. G. The treatment of congenital hydrocephalus. Med. Press & Circ, Dubl., 1937, 194: Suppl., p. hi-liv— Welter, H. Zur Frage des Hydrocephalus chondrodystrophicus congenitus. Beitr. path. Anat., 1936, 97: 1-8. --- Diagnosis. Backhaus, M. Beobachtungen mit der Enzephalographie zur Differentialdiagnose eines Hydrocephalus internus gegen- iiber Metastase nach intraokularem Tumor. Klin. Mbl. Augenh., 1923, 70: 330-5.—Bertolotti, M. I segni radiologici deU'idrocefaUa nelle sindromi endocrine neurogene primarie. Minerva med., Tor., 1936, 27: pt 1, 1-5.—Bokay, J. Ueber den Wert der Transparenz-Untersuchungen bei Hydrocephalus internus congenitus. Acta paediat., Upps., 1932, 13: 48-52.— Cloward, R. B. Hydrocephalus; diagnosis and treatment. Tr. M. Soc. Hawaii, 1940, 50: 91-100b, 3 pl.—Fanconi, G. Zur Diagnose und Therapie hydrocephalischer und verwandter Zustiinde. Schweiz. med. Wschr., 1934, 64: 214-23, pl — Hill, T. R. ?Recurrent acute internal hydrocephalus of idio- pathic origin; case for diagnosis. Proc. R. Soc. M., Lond., 1929-30, 23: Sect. Neur., 13.—Kopylov, M. B. Roentgen signs in hydrocephalus and their diagnostic value. Am. J. Roentg., 1936, 36: 659-73.-—Love, J. G. Transillumination of the head: an aid in the diagnosis of hydrocephalus. Proc. Mayo Clin., 1935, 10: 527.—Money, R. A. Neuro-surgical aids in the diag- nosis of hydrocephalus. Med. J. AustraUa, 1931, 1: 526-9, pl.—Young, A. W. A case of hydrocephalus simulating brain tumour. Canad. M. Ass. J., 1926, 16: 952-4. ---- Etiology. Acuna, M., & Vallino, M. T. HidrocefaUa hemorrdgica por ependimitis. Rev. espec, B. Air., 1928, 3: 833-40.—Alexander, L., & Suh, T. H. Note on the occurrence and significance of deficiency of the septum pellucidum. China M. J., 1934, 48: 138-41, 2 pl.—Arbuse, D. I. Hyperostosis cranii associated with internal hydrocephalus and metaboUc disturbances; report of case. Arch. Pediat., N. Y., 1937, 54: 323r38 — Bucciardi. G. Di una comunicazione stabiUtasi tra cavitS. del terzo ventricolo e spazi sottoaracnoidei, in soggetto idrocefaUco per chiusura dei fori di Magendie e Luska determinata da tumore del bulbo. CUn. pediat, Mod., 1926, 8: 43-50, pl — Dijkstra, O. H. [Hydrocephalus from stenosis and obstruction of Sylvian aqueduct] Ned. tschr. geneesk., 1930, 74: pt 2, 5685-93, 2 pl.—Eisenhardt, R. Cyst of the cavum Vergae with internal hydrocephalus. Neurosurg. Ward Rounds, 1940-41, 2: No. 5, 10-5.—Ellis, R. W. B. Internal hydrocephalus fol lowing cerebral thrombosis, in an infant. Proc. R. Soc. M., Lond., 1936-37, 30: 768-72.—Greenfield, J. G., & Stern, R. O. SyphiUtic hydrocephalus in the adult. Brain, Lond., 1932, 55: 367, pl.—Guillain, G., Bertrand, I., & Lereboullet, J. HydrocephaUe provoquee par une lesion systematis6e des plexus chorioides d'aspect tuberculoide et d'origine mdeterminee. Rev. neur., Par., 1935, 42: pt 2, 689-95.—Herter, C. A. Report of a case of sarcoma of the basal ganglia, mid-brain and pons with secondary asymmetrical hydrocephalus. Tr. Am. Neur. Ass 1897 23: 142-56.—Jacobs, A. G. Hydrocephalus follow- ing intracranial hemorrhage. South. M. J., 1926, 19: 669-73.— Lange, C. de [Hydrocephalus caused by obstruction of the aqueduct of Sylvius] Mschr. kindergeneesk., 1936, 5: 159-62— McAlpine, D. Toxic hydrocephalus. Brain, Lond., 1937, bO: 180-203—Parker, H. L., & McConnell, A. A. Internal hydro- cephalus resulting from a peculiar deformity of the hind-brain. Tr. Am. Neur. Ass., 1937, 63: 14-6.—Raspail, F. V. Hydro- cephaUe postgeniale acidogene ou hydrargtae. - Rev. compl. sc. appl. med., Par., 1855-56, 2: 257-9 —Russell, D. S., & Nevin, S. Aneurysm of the great vein of Galen causing internal hydrocephalus; report of 2 cases. J. Path Bact. Lond 1940 51: 375-83, pl.—Schneegans, E., & Mandigas Hydrocephahe non communicante du a un chordome mahn. BuU. hoc peoiat. Paris, 1938, 36: 535-8—Valladares, H. Hidrocefaha y tumor cerebral. Rev. argent, neur. psiquiat., Rosario, 1941, b: M3. Vercelli. Particolare reperto di stato idrocefahco in un caso di probabile tumor della convessita. cerebrale. Riv. otoneuroott., 1933, 10: 475-80.—Wyllie. W. G. Toxic hydrocephalus in a girl at the age of 10 years. Proc. R. Soc. M., Lond., 1938-39, 32: 218. ---- external. Gardner, W. J. Active external hydrocephalus; a report of 3 cases J. Nerv. Ment. Dis., 1932, 75: 601-ll.-Harbeson, kom lH.nal hydrocephalus. Canad. M. Ass. J., 1939, 41: 158-62.—Peiper.H. Ueber den ausseren Wasserkopf. Deut. Zschr. Chir., 1931, 234: 301-12.-Smith, E. H. External hydrocephalus due to stenosis of the longitudinal sinus and V?>oeIn?J, hemorrhagic pachymeningitis. Am. J. Dis. Child 1935, 49: 147-52—Verhaart, W. J. C. Epidural hydrocephalus externus with microgyry, microencephaly and rupture of the corpus callosum. Psychiat. neur. bl., Amst., 1936, 40: 17-23. ---- fetal. Hilgenfeld, H. *TJeber foetalen Hydro- cephalus und seine geburtshilfliche Bedeutung [Breslau] 19p. 8! Wurzb., 1935. Robinsohn, I. Contribution a l'etude de l'hydrocephahe foetale. 36p. 8? Par., 1935. Beruti, J. A., & Leon, J. HidrocefaUa fetal de extraordi- nary intensidad. Rev. espafi. obst., 1932, 17: 479-91. Also Sem. med., B. Air., 1932, 39: pt 2, 771.—Cathala, V. Erreurs de diagnostic que peut provoquer l'examen radiographique en particuher dans l'hydrocephalie foetale. BuU. Soc. obst. gyn. Paris, 1935, 24: 625-8. Also Gynecologie, 1936, 35: 242.— Desoubry, J. Observation d'une femme ayant eu successive- ment 3 enfants hydrocephales. BuU. Soc. obst. gyn. Paris 1927, 16: 371.—Iraeta, D., & Harguindeguy, E. HidrocefaUa fetal a repetici6n. Sem. med., B. Air., 1926, 33: pt 2, 934-7.— Laffont & Bonafos. Radiographic d'un hydrocgphale in-utero. BuU. Soc obst. gyn. Paris, 1934, 23: 640.—Leon, J., & Ferrari, R. A. Hidrocefalia fetal a repetici6n. Bol. Soc. obst. gin. B. Aires, 1936, 14: 506-17.—More, W. Treatment of foetal hydrocephalus. Brit. M. J., 1939, 2: 1273, pl.—Perez, M. L., & Linger, L. HidrocefaUa fetal a repetition. Rev. med. cubana, 1937, 48: 230-9.—Renther, Dardaillon & Lavabre. Deux observations d'hydroc6phaUe foetale au cours de la gestation. BuU. Soc. obst. gyn. Paris, 1934, 23: 290.—Torpin, R., & Holmes, L. P. Roentgen diagnosis of intra-uterine hydro- cephalus. Radiology, 1941, 37: 351.—Viana, O. Teratoma deU'orbita sinistra in feto idrocefaUco. Riv. ital. gin., 1926-27, 5: 393-423.—Walsh, C. H. Foetal hydrocephalus. Med. Press & Circ, Lond., 1939, 201: 380-6. ---- internal. Amotmino, G. Su di un caso d'idrocefalo interno e mielomeningocele. 17p. 8? Palermo, 1925. Bize, P. R. L'hydrocephalie ventriculaire; 6tude physio-clinique: physiologie normale de la circulation cephalo-rachidienne; physiologie pathologique de hydrocephalies; le syndrome ventriculaire. 528p. 8? Par., 1931. Dannheimer, W. [K. O.] *Ueber den Hydro- cephalus internus mit eigenen Fallen [Heidel- berg] 39p. 8? Worms, 1936. Mayer, K. *Ueber Aetiologie und Diagnose des Hydrocephalus internus an Hand von zwei Fallen. 22p. 8? Heidelb. [19-?] Schubert, H. *Ueber Hydrocephalus internus und seine Behandlung. 15p. 8? Kiel, 1934. Ask, O. [On the origin of hydrocephalus internus in spina bifida] Nord. med., 1940, 7: 1232-4.—Baker, C. G. A case of internal hydrocephalus, fatal 16 years after cerebrospinal meningitis, diagnosed as hysteria. Guy's Hosp. Rep., Lond., 1934, 84: 115-7.—Barbe, A., & Brizard, A. Mort en etat de mal epileptique avec obstruction du tronc basilaire et de ses branches dans un cas d'hydrocephale interne. Rev. neur., Par., 1935, 42: pt 2, 680-3.—Beardsley, E. Case of a hydrocephalus internus; read before N. H. Medical Society in 1787. Yale J. Biol., 1934, 6: 49-52.—Brault, P., Tizon, A., & Picot. Un cas d'hydrocephahe ventriculaire; diagnostic radiologique de l'hydrocephahe et de la voie operatoire. BuU. Soc. obst. gyn. Paris, 1935, 24: 435-7.—Brown, R. G. A case of spherical bulging of the floor of the third ventricle, secondary to internal hydrocephalus and simulating a pituitary tumour. J. Lar. Otol, Lond., 1928, 43: 728-30.—Fliigel. Ueber Hydrocephalus internus occlusus. Zbl. Chir., 1936, 63: 123.—Moritz, A. R., & Wartman, W. B. Post-traumatic internal hydrocephalus. Am. J. M. Sc, 1938, 195: 65-70, pl. Also repr.—Preuss, H. Ein Fall von Hydrocephalus internus acquisitus. Deut. tierarztl. Wschr., 1927, 35: 591-4.—Pujol Matabosch, J. A prop6sito de un caso de hidrocefalia ventricular; fundamentos para el diagn6stico. An. Hosp. S. Cruz, Barcel., 1929, 3: 312-5. ---- Manifestation. Gross, E. R. *Ein Fall von geschlechtlicher Fruhreife bei einem Kind mit Wasserkopf. 31p. 8? Tub., 1935. HYDROCEPHALUS Hampel, L. *Beitrag zum Hydrocephalus und seiner Bedeutung bei Sehstorungen. 39p. 8? Bresl., 192o. Le Locrd, R. H. M. *Sur les troubles oculaire au cours de l'hydrocephalie infantile. 75p. 2.")1/iicm. Bord.. 1934. Blau. A.. Reider. N.. & Bender. M. B. Extrapyramidal syndrome and encephalographic picture of progressive internal hydrocephalus in chronic hypoglycemia. Ann. Tnt. M., 1936-37, 10: 910-20.—Bokay, J. Ueber die semiotische Be- deutung der offenen embryonalen Fontanellen und weitere Beitrage zur Kenntnis der okkulten HydrocephaUe. Mschr. Kinderh., 1929. 42: 109-16.—Brauch, F. Zur Frage zentral bedingter Herzrhythmus-Storungen; voriibergehende Extra- systolie bei Hydrocephalus internus. Klin. Wschr., 1910, 19: 1157-9 (microfilm)—Dzierzynski, W. [Nanism in hydroce- phaly] Neur. polska, 1933-34, 16:-17: 21-30.—Ershov. V. A. [Case of Bekhterev's epilepsv in relation to hydrocephalus internus] Tr. obsh. nevropat. Saratov, 1927, 1: 265-70.— Fiinftreld, E. Ueber Epilepsie bei Hydrocephalus. Mschr. Psychiat., 1938, 99: 1-9.—Gierlich & Heile. Ueber Epilepsie infolge von Hydrocephalus internus acquisitus nach Schadel- trauma ohne aussere oder innere Verletzung. Miinch. med Wschr., 1927, 74: 1707-9.—Greiner, K. [Hvdrocephalus witl unusual symptoms] Orv. hetil.. 1939, 83: 971.—Griffith J. Q., jr, Fry, W. E.. k McGuinness, A. Experimental ana clinical studies in hy,-; with , special reference to the occurrence of papilledema. Am. .1. Ophth., 1940, 3. ser., 23: 24.5-51.—Hahn. R. Ily.hoeeple.lu-. Permeabilitat und Psy- chose. Mschr. Psvgyaszat, 1926, 66: 273.—Kirsch, O. Ein unter dem Bilde einer Ence- phalitis lethargica verlaufender Fall von Hvdrocephalus idiopathicus. Jahrb. Kinderh., 1933, 3. F., 90: 180-214 — Klein, E. Psychische Storungen bei encephalographisch nachgcwiesciiem Hydrocephalus internus. Deut. Zschr. Nervenh., 1936, 139: 211-8.— Krayenbuhl, H. Chronischer Hydrocephalus internus infolge einer der Arnold-Chiarischen Entwicklungsstorung nahestehenden Fehlbildung des Klein- hirns. Schweiz. med. Wschr., 1941, 71: 414-6.—Lange, W. Akromegalie und Adipositas bei hochgradigem Hydrocephalus. Endokrinologie, 1929, 4: 273-7.—Lhermitte, J. Le syndrome infundibulaire dans l'hydrocephalie; I'appareil regulateur de la fonction hypnique. Gaz. hop., 1927, 100: 621-4.—McConnell, A. A., & Parker, H. L. A deformity of the hind-brain associated with internal hydrocephalus; its relation to the Arnold-Chiari malformation. Biain, Lond., 1938, fil: 415-29.—Onsalo, E. Hidrocefalia interna con transparencia craneal. Arch, espafi. pediat., 1933, 17: 410-4.—Putnam, T. J. The mentality of infants relieved of hydrocephalus bv endoscopic coagulation of the chorioid plexuses. Tr. Am. Neur. Ass., 1937, 63: 147. Also Am. J. Dis. Child., 1938, 55: 990-9. Also J. Nerv. Ment. Dis., 1938, 87: 97-100.—Rademaker, G. G. J. [Remarkable case of disturbance of the labyrinth and optical reactions in a hydrocephalus internus] Ned. tschr. ireneesk., 1934, 78: 4815-9.—Schlesinger, B. Hydrocephalus with precocious puberty following post-basic meningitis. Proc. R. Soc. M., Lond., 1934-35, 28: 149.—Simchowicz, T. [Case of asthenia areflexia during sleep in hydrocephalus] Neur. polska, 1939, 22: 243-5.—Takeya-Siko. Hydrocephalus internus mit hvpophvsaren Erscheinungen. Arch. Psychiat., BerL, 1938, 108: 432-8.—Tonnis, W. Das Krankheitsbild des Hvdro- cephalus. Klin. Wschr., 1939. 18: 790.—Van Wagenen, W. P. Arnold Chiari syndrome associated with hypertrophy of external genitalia in the male; rehef of internal hydrocephalus by third ventricle fistula. Neurosurg. Ward Rounds, 1940-41, 2: No. 6, 6-8.—Werner, T. Zur Frage des Visusverfalles bei Gliomen mit hochgradigem Hydrocephalus internus und Liquormetastasen. Deut. Zschr. Nervenh., 1938, 145: 266- 74.—Worster-Drought. C, & Knight, G. C. Communicating hvdrocephalus simulating cerebral tumour. Proc. R. Soc. M., Lond., 1938-39, 32: Sect. Neur., 869-71. ---- Obstetric aspect. Braune, G. *Der Hydrocephalus in der Ge- burtshilfe. 23p. 8? Marb., 1936. Fulconis, H. A propos d'un cas d'hvdrocephalie. Bull. Soc. obst. gyn. Paris, 1937, 26: 631.—Mikerchyants, A. M. [Hvdrocephalus in breech presentation] Protok. zasaid. Kavkaz. med. Obsh., Tiflis, 1905-6, 42: 89-100- Munna, G. Un caso di idrocefalia. Riv. ostet. gin., 1933, 15: 310-2.— O'Connor. C. T., k Gorman, A. J. The treatment of hydro- cephalus in cephalic presentation. Am. J. Obst.. 1912, 43: 521—4.—Reimonet, J. Observation sur un accouchement d'un foetus hydrocephale, accompagne d'hemorragie uterine et de Tissue premature du cordon ombilidl Observ. provenc. sc. med., IS21. 1: 248-51.—Schockaert, R. Cas d'hydroce- phahe avec rupture du segment interieur ;hysterectomie vaginale; guerison. Rev. med., Louvain, 1924, 134-7.—Siedentopf, H. Der Hvdrozephalus als Geburtskomplikation. Deut. med Wschr., 1934, 60: 1419.—Verbeek, C. A. [Peculiar findings during l;ih,,r] Ned. whr. geneesk., 1926. 70: pt 2, 2362.— Wilder, E. M-, & Moldav.sky. L. F. Congenital hydrocephalus complicating labor; report of a case. South. Surgeon, 1941. 10: 861-73. HYDROCEPHALUS ---- otitic. See also Meningitis, pseudo; Otitis, Complica- tion, intracranial. Bourgeois, R. *Hydrocephnlics aigues et subaigues d'origine otique; accidents meninges otogenes purement hypertensifs. lSOp. 8° Par., 1935. Asherson, N. Otitic hydrocephalus; a record of 7 cases, with 2 cases simulating the condition. J. Lar. Otol., Lond 1939, 54: 319-42, 2 pl.—Bennet, J. Otitic hydrocephalus; a case record. J. R. Army M. Corps.. 1938, 71: 115 21.- Ilourgeois, R. Un cas d'hvdrocephalie externe diffuse d'oricine otique. Ann. otolar., Par., 1935, 669 76. -Cohen, ». Two cases of Otitic hydrocephalus. J. Lar. Otol., bond., 1910 55- 330-8.—Eraner. M. S., k Myers, D. Otitic hydrocephalus with a suggestion as to etiology. Ann. Otol. Rhinol., 1936 45: 553-66.—Errecart, P. L., Tolosa, E., & Galli. L. A. Hidro- cefalia externa difusa ologena. Hospital, Rio, 1939, 16: 199-204. Also Rev. As. med. argent.., 1939, 53: 453 5. Als,, Rev. san. mil., B. Air., 1939, 38: 379 85.-—Garland, H. <;., & Seed, G. S. Otitic hydrocephalus. Lancet, bond., 1933, 2: 751-3.—Gitt, J. J. Otitic hydrocephalus; report, of 2 cases. Laryngoscope, 1940, 50: 906-13— Gritti, P. Idrocefalia ventricolare otogena. Boll. mal. orecchio, 1937, 55: 287-300.— Jentzer, A. Un cas d'hydrocephahe. Rev. otoneur., Par., 1939, 17: 304.—Jerlang, E. [Hvdrocephalus and otitis Hospitalstidende, 1938, 81: 1028-40.—Kessler, M. M., & Savitsky, N. Otitic and sphenoiditic hydrocephalus; the value of the Ayala index. J. Mount Sinai Hosp. N. York, 1938-39, 5: 486-90.—McAlpine, D. Chronic external hydrocephalus following otitis media and ablation of lateral sinus. Proc. R. Soc. M., Lond., 1938-39, 32: 215- 7. -Mayoux. R. Hydro- cephalic de la fosse cerebrale posterieure d'origine otique. Ann. otolar., Par., 1939, 719.—Pagano, A. Idrocefalia sub- acuta esterna diffusa di origine otitica. Valsalva, 1938, 14: 305-73.—Piquet, J. Les formes fmstos de l'hydrocephalie otique. Ann. otolar., Par., 1938, 557-64.—Rebattu, Deric & Mayoux. Syndrome de compression du tronc c6r6bral au cours d'une hydrocephahe ventriculaire d'origine otique. Ibid., 1939, 700-3.—Reeves, E. Otorhinogenic hydrocephalus. Arch. Otolar., Chic, 1941, 34: 920-35.—Rosenwasser, H. Otitic hydrocephalus. Laryngoscope, 1940, 50: 307-12.— Seal, J. C. Otitic hydrocephalus (pseudomeningitis) report of a case. Ibid., 1932, 42: 936-42.—Symonds, C. P. Otitic hydrocephalus. Brain, Lond., 1931, 54: 55-71.------ Otitic hydrocephalus: a report of 3 cases. Brit. M. J., 1932, 1: 53.—Williams, H. L. Otitic hydrocephalus. Tr. Am. Lar. Rhin. Otol. Soc, 1937, 43: 152-73. Also Arch. Otolar., 1937, 25: 632-52. ------- The underlying factors concerned in otitic hydrocephalus. Tr. Am. Lar. Rhin. Otol. Soc, 1938, 44: 36-83. Also Ann. Otol. Rhinol., 1938, 47: 670-714 — Zimmerman, G. S. [Diagnosis and treatment of hydrocephaly of otogenous origin] Sovet. psikhonevr., 1939, 15: No. 2, 85-93. Also Vest, otorinolar., 1938, 266-77. ---- Pathogenesis. Lebreton, E. L. *Les hemorragies m6ningees du nouveau-ne dans leur rapport avec l'hydro- cephalie. 44p. 241/4cm. Bord., 1933. Volkmann, H. *Beitrage zur Pathogenese des Hydrocephalus internus. 24p. 8? Berl., 1933. Brenner, W Beitrag zur Kenntnis der Pathogenese des Hydrocephalus internus; Vergleich von neurologischen, ront- genologischen und anatomischen Befunden. Zschr. Kinderh., 1939, 61: 265-96.—Caramazza, P. Studio chnico e speri- mentale sull'idrocefalo. PolicUnico, 1927, 34: sez. prat., 1315.— Clark, F. H. Hydrocephalus, a hereditary character in the house mouse. Proc. Nat. Acad. Sc. U. S., 1932, 18: 654-6. -------■ Two hereditary types of hydrocephalus in the house mouse (Mus musculus) Ibid., 1935, 21: 150-2. ------ Linkage relations of hydrocephalus in the mouse, Mus musculus. Ibid., 1936, 22: 474-8— D'Abundo, E. Ricerche sperimentali sulla patogenesi dell'idrocefalo. Neurologica, Nap., 1926, 3: 257-70, 2 pl.—Dunlop, H. A. The pathogenesis, symptoms, and treatment of hydrocephalus Westminster Hosp Rep., 1934, 22: 123-35.—Estella, J. Patogenia v tratamiento de la hidrocefalia esencial. Progr. cUn., Madr., 1930, 38: 593-605.— Fujibayashi, K. Ueber den experimentellen Hydrocephalus internus durch Intraneuralinjektion von Tusche. Acta Scholae med. Univ. Kioto, 1929, 12: 195-213, pl.—Goodman, I. B. Sphenoiditic hydrocephalus. Laryngoscope, 1942, 52: 101-9.— Guleke, N. Ueber die Entstehung des Hydrocephalus internus. Arch. klin. Chir., 1930, 162: 533-50 [Discussion! 146.— Heidrich, L. Beitrag zu der Entstehung des Hydrocephalus internus und den ventrikuliiren Liquor-Resorptionsstellen. Beitr. klin. Chir., 1930-31, 151: 607-12.—Heydner. W. Leber die Bedeutung des Foramen parietale am Schadel. Allg. Zschr. Psychiat., 1930, 93: 137-44, tab.—Hoen, T.I. The choroid plexus as a dialyzing membrane; observations in experimental hydrocephalus. Arch. Neur. Psychiat., Chic, 1931, 26: 496- 500.-—Jeanselme, E. De l'hydrocephalie; son niecunUme, :-,•- causes, son traitement. Rev. g6n. cUn. ther., 1927, 41:689- 92.—Koeppe, H. Ueber Hydrocephalus occultus, zerebrale HYDROCEPHALUS 927 HYDROCEPHALUS Rachitis und Hydrocephalus rachiticus. Arch. Kinderh., 1926, 78: 83-104.—Levaditi, C, & Schoen, R. Hydrocephale experi- mentale provoquee par l'ultravirus de la maladie de Nicolas- Favre chez la souris. C. rend. Soc. biol., 1936, 122: 876-9 — Lindau, A. Observations on the pathogenesis of hydrocephalus. Acta path, microb. scand., 1928, 5: 25-51.—McClelland, J. E. The syndrome of hydromicrocephaly. J. Pediat., S. Louis, 1940, 16: 36-51.—Mako, A. E. Internal hydrocephalus, due to chronic adhesive arachnoiditis, cured by operation. Clin. Bull., Clevel., 1940, 4: 56-8.—Parker, H. L., & Kernohan, J. W. Stenosis of the aqueduct of Sylvius. Tr. Am. Neur. Ass., 1932, 58: 435-57.—Perk, J. Ueber die Pathogenese des Hydro- cephalus nach klinischen und experimentellen Daten. Fol. neuropath, eston., 1932, 12: 118-27.—Pommer, G. Beitrage zur Kenntnis der hydrocephaUschen und cystischen Hohlraum- bUdungen des Grosshirns (im besonderen zur Kenntnis des Cavum Vergae, der porenccphalischen Hydranencephalie und der Hydromikrencephalie bei angeborener Hirngefaszsyphilis, mit einem Anhang von Befunden bei erworbener Hirnarterien- syphilis) Virchows Arch., 1931, 282: 456-539.—Redaelli, P., & Previtera, A. Considerazioni sulla genesi dell'idrocefalo interno sperimentale da nero fumo. Riv. pat. nerv., 1934, 44: 601-28, 2 pl.—Schleussing, H. Vergrosserung der Kleinhirn- tonsille als Ursache des Hvdrocephalus internus. Zschr. ges. Neur. Psychiat., 1931, 132: 264-8.—Sneeden. V. D., & Larson, C. P. Internal hydrocephalus due to syringomyelia-like process of aqueduct of Sylvius. Northwest M., 1941, 40: 44.—Stroink, J A [Hydrocephaly in twins, and investigation on heredity] Ned. tschr. geneesk., 1937, 81: 779-83, 2 pl.—Stuck, R. M., & Reeves, D. L. Dangerous effects of thorotrast used intra- cranially; with special reference to experimental production of hydrocephalus. Arch. Neur. Psychiat., Chic, 1938, 40: Se- ll 5.—Telatin, L. Idrocefalo sperimentale a mezzo di altera- zioni neUa sostanza nervosa. Gior. psichiat., 1934, 61: 294-311, 1 pl —Tonnis, W. Hydrozephalus infolge Liquorzirkulations- storung. Arch. Kinderh., 1939, 118: 65-79. Also Riv. pat. nerv 1940, 55: 129-47.—Torello Cendra, M. Concepto de la hidrocefaUa. Med. ibera, 1935, 29: pt 2, 77. ---- Pathology. Feebel, H. [M. G. L.] *Die Bildung des Gesichtsschadels beim Hydrocephalus. 16p. 8? Greifswald, 1935. Patrikalakis. M. *Zur Pathologie des Hydro- cephalus internus. 20p. 8? Gott., 1927. Ahnsjo, S. Vergleichende Untersuchungen uber die redu- zierenden Substanzen im Ventrikel- und Lumballiquor bei hydrozephalen Kindern. Acta paediat., Upps., 1936, 19: 141-52.—Auersperg, A. Das Verhalten der Kerne am Boden des III. Ventrikels bei Hydrozephalus. Arb. Neur. Inst. Wien, 1927 30- 163-9—B., L. v. L'hydrocephalie ventriculaire. J. neur. psychiat., Brux., 1932, 32: 317-34.—Beruti, J. A., Leon, J., & Sanmartino, R. Estudio anatomo-patologico de un hidrocefalo extraordinario. Prensa med. argent., 1932-33, 19: 1218-23.—Blackfan. K. D., Crothers, B., & Banz, R. N. Trans- mission of intracranial pressure in hydrocephalus in infancy. Am. J. Dis. Child., 1929, 38: 893-9. Also repr.—Bland- Sutton, J. Hydrocephalus; a study in phylogeny and pathology. Lancet, Lond., 1928, 2: 687-90.—Brown, R. G. A case of spherical bulging of the floor of the third ventricle, secondary to internal hydrocephalus and simulating a pituitary tumour. Proc. R. Soc. M., Lond., 1927-28, 21: Sect Otol., 70-3 — Brunner, H. Klinischer und anatomischer Ohrbefund beim Hydrocephalus internus. Mschr. Ohrenh., 1933, 67: 1309-21.— Craig, W. McK. Hydrocephalus; the diagnosis treatment arid pathologic change in 2 unusual cases. West. J. Surg 19^2, 40: 562-6.—Da Costa, D. G., & Adson, A. W Subdural hydroma. Arch. Surg., 1941, 43: 559-67.-Derville & Pauly. Sur un cas d'hydrocephahe communicante. J. med Bordeaux, 1936,_ 113. 373-5.—Dietrich, A. Zur Topographie der Cisterna cerebello- medullaris bei Hydrocephalus Zschr. ^s. Neur. Psychiat 1929, 121: 224-35.-DoIan, D. J., & Grand, M J H. Hydio- cephklus of unusual size. J. Pediat., S. Louis, 193o. 6. 9^7.— Draganesco, Sager, L., & Kreindler, A. Rigidite d«-cerebrte dans un cas d'hydrocephahe chez un enfant; recherches sur I'excitabiUte neuro-musculaire et labynnthique. Enc6phale, 1929, 24: 661-6, pl.—Ganfini, G. I plessi conoidei e 1 acque- dotto cerebrale in un caso di hydrocephalus ooclusus Riv. sner freniat 1940, 64: 83-96.—Globus, J. H. Commum- caring hydrocephalus: so-called idiopathic hydrocephalus. Am T Dis Child 1928, 36: 680-701.—Guillery. H. Be- sJndere fefunde an'l.ydrocephalen Gehirnen. Virchows Arch. 1926 262- 499-507 —Hassin, G. B. Hydrocephalus; studies on the^pfthology and pathogenesis with remarks on the cere- brospinal fluid. Arch. Neur Psychiat., Chrc 1930, 2L 1164-86 Also repr. ------ Hydrocephalus; leportot a case in'aiT infant w[th vestiges of a choroid plexus in■ thefourth ventricle onlv Tr. Am. Neur. Ass., 1931, 57. oi^-u. JlcobDie gestaltlichen Veranderungen und Verlagerungen desCKieinhlrnlbei HydrocephaUe. Zschr. ges Near. Psychiat 1939 165- 309—Kraus, L. Hydrozephalus unci lnnenonr. Hals'&c Arzt Teil 1, 1936, 27: 64-80 -Lange C. de [Hydro- cephalus biperforatus] Mschr. kindergeneesk.1932 33 2. fi7_7t; 4 nl —Leland, H. R- Recurrent hydrocephalus. Am. J707bStSP935,2l:886.---LieberS M UeberjbgdrocgWijeta Hemiatropbia cerebri. Arch. Psychiat., Berl,, 1935, 1UJ. 323-34.—Mase, K. A dissected case of colossal hydrocephalus in?«UrL°f ,the ,brai,n substar»ce. Orient. J. Dis. Inf., Kvoto, 1940, 28: 1, pl. ch.—Pedrazzini, F. Les hydrocephalies et 1 oedeme cerebral. Presse med., 1938, 46: 1862.—Rukstinat, G. Focal calcification of the brain and dura of a hydrocephalic idiot child. Arch. Path., Chic, 1935, 19: 47-52.—Sainz de los Terreros, C. Hidrocefalo gigante. Progr. clin., Madr 1916 7: ,29,1-,9' P1-—Shlykov, A. A. [Ventricular fluid in hvdro^ cephaly] Nevropat. psikhiat., 1936, 5: 111-26.—Takashima, O. Experimentelle Studien an Kaninchen iiber die durch Hydrocephalus hervorgerufenen pathologischen Veranderungen des Gehororgans. Mitt. Med. Akad. Kioto, 1939, 26: 811.— Winfield, K. Hydrocephalus; considered in relation to intra- cranial pressure. J. Am. Inst. Homeop., 1932, 25: 377-89.— Zolotowa. N. A. Degeneration des Gehirnbalkens bei Hydro- cephalic Virchows Arch., 1931, 280: 343-50. ---- Surgery. Pinatzis, P. *La perforation de la lame sus- optique; proced6 de traitement de l'hydro- cephalie interne par drainage du Hie ventricule. 77p. 25cm. Lyon, 1939. Brault, P., Tizon, A., & Picot. Un cas d'hydrocephahe ventriculaire; diagnostic radiologique de l'hydrocephalie et de la voie operatoire. Gynecologic 1936, 35: 96.—Chibukmacher, N. B. [Experimental verification of Heile's operation] Nov. khir. arkh., 1936, 35: 561-5.—Christopher, F. Ureterodural anastomosis. Surg. Clin. N. America, 1929, 9: 473-9.—■ Dandy, W. E. Extirpation of the choroid plexus of the lateral ventricles in communicating hydrocephalus. Ann. Surg., 1918, 68: 569-79, 5 pl— Davidoff, L. M. Treatment of hydro- cephalus; historical review and description of a new method. Arch. Surg., 1929, 18: 1737-62. ------ & Bancroft. F. W. Ureterodural anastamosis for the treatment of hydrocephalus; report of a case. Ibid., 1932, 25: 550.—D'Errico, A. A surgical procedure for hydrocephalus associated with spina bifida. Surgery, 1938, 4: 856-66. Also Yale J. Biol., 1938-39, 11: 425-30, pl. ------ The present status of operative treatment for hydrocephalus. South. M. J., 1942, 35: 247-52— Doughty, R. G. Operative treatment of infantile hvdrocephalus. J. S. Carolina M. Ass., 1934, 30: 51-4.—Fridman, M. T. [Heile's operation in hydrocephalus] Nov. khir. arkh., 1937, 39: 567- 71.—Gabai, A. V. [Evaluation of Heile's uretero-duro- anastomosis in communicating hydrocephaly) Khirurgia, Moskva, 1938, No. 2, 74-84.—Gallagher, W. J. Hydrocephalus (dura-ureteral drainage) J. Missouri M. Ass., 1935, 32: 402- 5.—Ginsburg, I. S. [Operative treatment of dropsy of the head] J. teor. prakt. med., 1926, 2: 39-47.—Gordon, A. Hydro- cephalus with cessation of persistent epileptic convulsions after puncture of the lateral ventricles. J. Am. M. Ass., 1927, 88: 1234.—Heile, B. Zur Behandlung des Hydrocephalus mit Ureter-Duraanastomose. Zbl. Chir., 1927, 54: 1859-64. Zur Dauerableitung des Liquors bei Hydrocephalus mit Einheilungsresultaten der Implantate. Beitr. klin. Chir., 1928 145: 1-30.—Heimanovich, Z. I. [Therapy of hydro- cephalus] Vopr. neirokhir., 1939, 3: 65-8.—Hiller, R. I. Simple technique for inserting a silk seton with report of its use in a case of communicating hydrocephalus and description of a seton needle and suggestions for its use. Am. J. Surg., 1933, 20: 119-21.—Hortolomei, N-, Paulian, D., & Tonesco- Miltiade, J. HydrocephaUe ventriculaire unilaterale; drainage permanent du ventricule; guerison cUnique. Rev. neur., Par., 1933, 40: pt 1, 536-41.—Ingebrigtsen, R. [Treatment of hydro- cephalus internus bv permanent drainage of the third ventricle] Norsk mag. laegevid., 1938, 99: 976-89.—Jennings, J. E. Hydrocephalus in infancy. Surg. Clin. N. America, 1927, 7: 901-8.—Krivonosov, M. S. [Operative treatment of hydro- cephaly in young children] KUn. med., Moskva, 1937, 15: 744-6.—Kuntzen, H. Ueber Hydrocephalusbehandlung. Zbl. Chir., 1936, 63: 124. ■------ Die chirurgische Behandlung des Hydrocephalus, insbesondere durch Elektrokoagulation des Plexus chorioideus auf endoskopischem Wege. Arch. klin. Chir., 1941, 201: 707-26 (microfilm)—Lehman, E. P. Uretero- arach'noid (ureterodural) anastomosis, with report of 3 cases. Ann Surg., 1934, 100: 887-905. Also Tr. Am. Surg. Ass., 1934, 52- 504-22—Marburg, O. Zur Therapie des Hydrocephalus, Arch. ital. chir., 1938, 52: 789-801.—Meeker. W. R., & Muscat. J O. Ureterodural anastomosis in hydrocephalus. J. M. Ass Alabama, 1937-38, 7: 119-21.—Mironov, A. I. [Experimental data in evaluation of Heile's operation for hydrocephalus] Nevropat. psikhiat., 1937, 6: No. 6, 98-102.—Nobili, U. Dell'idrocefalo ventricolare congenito e della sua cura chirurgica Arch. ital. chir., 1935, 41: 501-36.—Putnam, T. J. Treatment of hydrocephalus by endoscopic coagulation of choroid plexuses. J Nerv Ment. Dis., 1934, 80: 709. Also N. England J. M., 1934 210: 1373-6. Also Tr. Am. Neur. Ass., 1935, 61: 133. AlsoArch. Pediat., N. Y., 1935, 52: 676r85.-Reichert F. L. Hydrocephalus. In Textb. Surg. (Christopher, F.) 3. ed., Phila 1942 436-41.—Scarff, .1. E. Endoscopy in the treat- ment'of hydrocephalus; description of a new ventriculoscope; preliminary report of cases Tr. Am Neur Ass 1935 bl: 135-8 Also Arch. Neur. Psychiat., Chic, 1936, 36: 1400-2. Nonobstructive hydrocephalus; treatment by endo- scopic cauterization of the choroid plexuses. Am. J. Dis. Child., 1942 63: 297-334.—Schopbauer, L. Resezierung des Plexus chorioideus ventriculi lateralis wegen Hydrocephalus Wien. med. Wschr., 1927, 77: 1665.—Sharpe, W. Tratamiento 528 HYDROCEPHALUS HYDROCEPHALUS nperatorio de la hidrocefalia. Cr6n. med. quir. Habana, 1926, 32: 171-8. Also Rev. med. cir. Habana, 1926, 31: 79-91 — Sokolov, N. I. [Operative treatment of acquired internal l.vdroceplialus] Nov. khir. arkh., 1940-41, 48: 206-10.— Stookey. B. A rational surgical treatment of obstructive hydrocephalus due to tumors or congenital stenosis of the aqueduct of Sylvius in adults. Tr. Am. Neur. Ass., 1935, 61: 121-4. ------ A- ScarlT. J. Occlusion of the aqueduct of Sylvius by neoplastic and non-neoplastic processes with a rational surgical treatment for reUef of the resultant obstructive hydrocephalus. BuU. Neur.Inst. N. York, 1936, 5: 348-77.— Tilmann. Zur Frage des Hydrocephalus. Deut. Zschr. Chir., 1931, 232: 199-207.—Vana, A. [Infratemporal drainage of the ventricles in congenital hydrocephalus] Cas. lek. Cesk., 1926, 65: 20-4.—Warner, E. C. Hydrocephalus successfully treated by repeated puncture of the lateral ventricles. Proc. R. Soc. M., Lond., 1933, 26: 1007.—Wertheimer, P. Traitement de l'hydrocephahe interne avec blocage des voies ventriculaires; drainage par incision de la lame susoptique. Helvet. med acta, 1938, 5: 786-8. ------ & Mansuy, L. L'incision de la lame sus-optique; procede de traitement de l'hydrocephalie interne par drainage du troisieme ventricule. J. chir., Par., 1938, 51: 838-48.—White, J. C. Drainage of the third ventricle by transfrontal approach in obstructive hydrocephalus. Yale J. Biol., 1938-39, 11: 431, pl. ---- traumatic. Albert!. Ueber die Cefalo-idrocele traumatica. Schweiz. med. Wschr., 1933, 63: 172.—Bettinotti, S. Y. Hidrocefalia traumatica, en un recien nacido. Rev. espec, B. Air., 1928, 3: 41-5.—Hashiguchi, M. Experimentelle Untersuchungen iiber den traumatisehen Hydrocephalus. Arb. Neur. Inst. Wien., 1927, 29: 109-40.—Tavernier, L. HydrocephaUe interne post- traumatique simulant un abeds cerebral. P. verb. Congr. fr. chir., 1928, 37: 870-3.— Trendtel. Der traumatische Hydro- cephalus in der Unfadmedizin. Zbl. Gewerbehyg., 1930, n. F., 7: 139-42. ---- Treatment. Geiss, F. *Ueber 3 Falle von entzundlichem Hydrocephalus und ihre Behandlung. 31p. 8? Erlangen, 1937. Mohamed El Gibry, M. *Die Behandlung des Hydrocephalus. 22p. 8? Berl., 1928. Antenucci, A. J., & Sailer, S. Obstructive hydrocephalus during course of cerebrospinal fever cured by ventricular punc- ture and intraventricular instillation of serum. J. Am. M. Ass., 1934, 102: 690.—Couto, M. Sobre um caso de hydro- cephalo idiopathico com a forma cUnica do syndromo de Weber; cura immediata pela punccao lombar. In his CUn. med., Rio, 1936, 3: 113-9.—Fiildes, E. Antiretentional therapy in con- ditions ascribed to intracranial Uquid accumulation. Am. J. Psychiat., 1936, 92: 1281-90.—Gardos. S. Mit Luftein- blasungen geheilter Fall von nach Meningitis entstandenem Hydrocephalus externus. Mschr. Kinderh., 1939—40, 81: 124-7.—Harrower, G. Hydrocephalus; a plea for its early diagnosis and treatment. Malay. M. J., 1933, 8: 176-9.— Hydrocephalus and its treatment. Ind. M. Rec, 1935, 55: 259.—Jacobi, W., & Magnus, G. Pharmakologische Beein- flussung des Hirnwassers. Arch. Psychiat., Berl., 1925, 74: 126-38.—Kohlmann, G. Die Rontgentherapie des Hydro cephalus internus und verwandter KrankheitsbUder. Strahlen- therapie, 1933, 47: 689-93. Also Verh. Deut. Rontg. Ges., 1933, 26: 105.—Lange, C. de. Spontaneous heaUng in a case of hydrocephalus. Proc. Akad. wet. Amsterdam, Sect. Sc, 1929, 32: pt 1, 78-85, 4 pl.—Lederer, E. von. Ueber Strahlen- behandlung des Hydrozephalus. Arch. Kinderh., 1935, 106: 31-7.—Nesbit, H. T. Hydrocephalus successfully treated by the use of theobromin sodiosahcylate. South. M. J., 193i, 24: 1028-32.—Piquet. Le s6rum glucose hypertonique dans l'hydrocephalie. Ann. otolar., Par., 1939, 309-12.—Prussak, L. Zur Behandlung des durch die Meningitis epidemica bedingten Hydrocephalus. Ther. Gegenwart, 1929, 70: 282.—Putnam, T. J. Hydrocephalus. In Modern Med. Ther. (Barr, D. P) Bait., 1940, 2: 2028.—Royle, N. D. Drainage of cerebrospinal fluid in treatment of hydrocephalus, syringomyelia, and syringo- bulbia. J. Am. M. Ass., 1938, 110: 1264-6.—Scarff, J. E. Endoscopic treatment of hydrocephalus; description of a ven- triculoscope and preUminary report of cases. Arch. Neur Psychiat., Chic, 1936, 35: 853-61.—Schieber, M. |Radio- therapy in hydrocephalus, headaches and epilepsy] Pol-ka gaz. lek., 1937, 16: 882-5.—Schonbauer, L., & Hutter, K. Zm Behandlung des Hydrocephalus. Wien. kUn. Wschr., 1929, 42: 806.—Siedamgrotzky. Beeinflussung der Produktion des Ventrikelliquor durch Rontgenbestrahlung der Plexus chorioidei Arch. klin. Chir., 1927, 145: 122-7.—Snoo, de [Therapy of hydrocephalus! Ned. tschr. verlosk., 1931-32, 35: 120-4.— Walsh. C. H. Hydrocephalus: a method of treatment ' J Obst. Gyn., Brit. Empire, 1934, 41: 1039.—White, J. C, & Michelsen, J. J. Treatment of obstructive hydrocephalus in adults. Surg. Gyn. Obst., 1942, 74: 99-109. ---- unilateral. Dott, N. M. A case of left unilateral hydrocephalus in an infant; operation; cure. Brain. Lond., 1927, 50: 548-61.— Papez, J. W., & Rundles, R. W. Thalamus of a dog without a hemisphere due to a undateral congenital hydrocephalus. J Comp. Neur., 1938, 69: 89-102.—Stewart, R. M. Unilateral hydrocephalus; report of 2 cases of the non-obstructive type J. Ment. Sc, Lond., 1940, 86: 591-001, 3 pl. ---- in animals. Barber, C. W. Unilateral hydrocephalus: a case report, Cornell Vet., 1936, 26: 350-2.—Craig, J. F. Internal hydro- cephalus in a horse. Vet. Rec, Lond., 1937, 17: 478.—Fili- monov, I. N. Ein Fall von Hydrozephalie beim Hunde .1 Psychol. Neur., Lpz., 1928-29, 37: 673-8.—Houck. J. W. Hydrocephalus in lower animals; congenital occurrence in a calf and an albino rat. Anat. Rec, 1930-31, 45: 83-106.— Hyde, R. R. An epidemic of hydrocephalus in a group of experimental rabbits. Am. J. Hyg., 1940, 31: Sect. B, 1-7, pl.—Matthias, D. Untersuchungen iiber das Wesen des Hydrocephalus internus acquisitus des Pferdes. Arch, wiss prakt. Tierh., 1937, 72: 48-78.—Schlotthauer, C. F. Internal hydrocephalus in a dog. J. Am. Vet. M. Ass., 1934, 85: 788- 94. ------ Internal hydrocephalus in dogs. Ibid., 1936, 89: 141-9.—Wester, J. [Internal hydrocephalus] Tschr. dier- geneesk., 1934, 61: 1-14, 2 pl.—Williams, W. L., & Frost, J. N. Subdural hydrocephalus in a calf. Cornell Vet., 1938, 28: 340-5. HYDROCHLORIC acid. See under Chlorine. HYDROCINCHONIDINE. See Cinchona, Alkaloids. HYDROCORES. See also Hemiptera. Oevermann, H. Das statische Verhalten einiger Wasser- wanzenarten. Zschr. wiss. Zool., 1935-36, 147: 595-628. HYDROCYANIC acid. See under Cyanic acid. HYDRODYNAMICS. See also Fluid. Eckermann, R. Etudes sur l'hydrodynamique avec des references speciales sur l'hydrographie. C. rend. Congr. internat. hydr. clim. g6ol. med. (1933) 1934, 14. Congr., 351.— Hauser, E. A.. & Dewey, D. R., II. Visual studies of flow patterns. J. Phys. Chem., 1942, 46: 212.—Lin, C. C. On the motion of vortices in 2 dimensions; existence of the Kirchhoff- Routh function. Proc Nat. Acad. Sc. U. S., 1941, 27: 570-5. ;-----On the motion of vortices in 2 dimensions; some further investigations on the Kirchhoff-Routh function. Ibid., 575- 7.—Munk, M. M. On some vortex theorems of hydrodynamics. J. Aeronaut. Sc, 1941-42, 9: 90-6. HYDROGEN. See also Deuterium; also proper names of chemical substances. Ahlberg, J. E., Estermann, I., & Lundberg, W. O. A simplified hydrogen liquefier. Rev. Sc. Instrum., 1937, 8: 422-6.—Corriez, P. L'hydrogene ancien element simple. J. pharm. chim., Par., 1934, 8. ser., 19: 601-16.—Gesteau, P. Ln appareil producteur d'hydrogene pur. Ibid., 1937, 8. ser., 26: 11-7.—Graf, E. Wasserstoff in der chemischen Industrie. Zschr. Gewerbehyg., 1937, 44: 163; 181.—Mass three discover- ies close gap in elements. Science News Lett., 1934, 25: 245.— Starr, C. The design of hydrogen liquefiers. Rev. Sc. Instrum.. 1941, 12: 193-8.—Taylor, H. S. The significance of industrial hydrogen. Chem. Metallurg. Engin., 1923, 28: 931.—Thomp- son, J. D. The value of hydrogen. Eating Your Way to Health, 1933, 2: 1-4.—Vencov, S. Contribution k l'etude de la decharge par choc eiectronique dans l'hydrogene. Ann. phys., Par., 1931, 10. ser., 15: 131-266, pl— Viatkin, V. [Energizing role of hydrogen in biochemical processes] Priroda, Leningr., 1937, 26: 100.—Winling. Sur la preparation de l'hydrogene par le procede Dempster. Arch. med. pharm. nav.. Par.. 1927, 117: 239-53. ---- Chemistry. Lorch, A. E. *A study of the catalytic properties of bright platinum and iridium de- posits in the activation of hydrogen. 29p. 8: N. Y., 1932. Amdur, I. The temperature coefficient of the recombination rate of atomic hydrogen. Abstr. Theses Univ. Pittsburgh, 1932, 8: 7-14.—Baars, E. Die Ueberspannung bei elektro- lytischer Bildung des Wasserstoffs. Sitzber. Ges. Naturwiss Marburg, 1929, 63: 213-320.—Bancroft, W. D., & Gould. L. P. The hydrols. J. Phys. Chem., Ithaca, 1934, 38: 197-211 — HYDROGEN 929 HYDROGEN Barrer, R. M., & Rideal, E. K. The interaction of hydrogen with micro-crystalline charcoal. Proc. R. Soc, Lond., 1935, 149: ser. A, 231-53.—Bell, R. P. Quantum mechanical effects in reactions involving hydrogen. Ibid., 148: ser. A, 241-50.— Bial, M. Ueber die antiseptische Funktion des H-Ions ver- dunnter Sauren. Zschr. phys. Chem., 1902, 40: 513-34 — Breslow, I). S., & Hauser, C. R. Condensations; condensations of certain active hydrogen compounds effected by boron trifluoride and aluminum chloride. J. Am. Chem. Soc, 1940, 62: 2385-8.—Chapman, D. L., & Gregory, G. The catalysis by palladium of the union of hydrogen and oxygen; a new phenomenon of contact catalysis. Proc. R. Soc, Lond., 1934, 147: ser. A, 68-75.—Coutiere. Ions hydrogene et physiologie generale. Biol, med., Par., 1924, 14: 387-409.—Craggs, J. D., & Smee, J. F. Action of fast hydrogen ions on lithium chloride. Nature, Lond., 1941, 148: 531.—Cremer, E. Reaktionsverlauf der o-p-Wasserstoffumwandlung in festem Wasserstoff. Zschr. phys. Chem., Abt. B, 1935, 28: 199-214.—Dixon, J. K. The reactions of hydrogen atoms with hydrazine and with am- monia. J. Am. Chem. Soc, 1932, 54: 4262-71.—Farkas, L., & Sachsse, H. Ueber die homogene Katalyse der Para-Ortho- vvassei stoffumwandlung durch paramagnetische Stoffe. Sitz- ber. Preuss. Akad. Wiss., phys. math. KL, 1933, 268-79. Also Zschr. phys. Chem., Abt. B, 1933, 23: 1-18. Ueber die Rekombination von Wasserstoffatomen und ihre Reaktion mit Sauerstoff und Kohlenoxyd. Ibid., 1934, 27: 111-29.—Foord, S. G., & Norrish, R. G. W. A study of sensitized explosions; the hydrogen oxygen reaction catalysed by nitrogen peroxide. Proc R. Soc, Lond., 1935, 152: ser. A, 196-220.—Geib, K. H., & Harteck, P. Die Einwirkung von atomarcm auf molekularen Wasserstoff. Zschr. phys. Chem., 1931, Ergbd., 849-62.—Gordy, W. Bonding through hydrogen. Sc. Month., 1941, 53: 440-3. ------& Stanford, S. C. Spec- troscopic evidence for hydrogen bonds; SH, NH and NH2 compounds. J. Am. Chem. Soc, 1940, 62: 497-505.—Griffiths, J. H. E. The mean Uves of excited hvdrogen atoms. Proc. R. Soc, Lond., 1934, 147: ser. A, 547-55— Heiple, H. R. The thermal reaction between hydrogen and oxygen. Univ. Pittsburgh BuU., 1942, 38: No. 2, 212-23, Abstr.—Kenner, J., Polanyi, M., & Szego, P. Aluminium chloride as a catalyst of hydrogen interchange. Nature, Lond., 1935, 135: 267.— Klemenc, A., & Patat, F. Zur Kenntnis des Verhaltens von atomarem Wasserstoff; das Verhalten des Pentans gegen ultraviolettes Licht und seiner Polymerisationsprodukte gegen Sauerstoff; der Quecksilbereinfluss bei dieser Reaktion. Zschr. phys. Chem., Abt. A, 1930, 149: 449-64.—Kluyver, A. J., & Donker, H. J. L. [Catalytic transfer of hydrogen as basis of chemical dissimilation processes] Versl. Akad. wet. Am- sterdam, 1925, 34: 237-51.—Knorr, C. A., & Schwartz, E. Ueber die katalytische Aktivitat des Palladiums und die Ueberspannung des Wasserstoffs. Zschr. phys. Chem., Abt. A, 1936, 176: 161-8.—Lawton, X. C. The recombination of hydro- gen atoms. Univ. Pittsburgh Bull., 1936, 33: No. 1, 151-9 — Lee, S. B., & Umbreit, W. W. Biological oxidation of molecular hydrogen. Zbl. Bakt., 2. Abt., 1939-40, 101: 354-63 — Lombard, V., & Eichner, C. A propos des varietes d'hydrogene; essai de fractionnement par diffusion k travers le palladium. J. chim. phys., Par., 1934, 31: 396-406.—Majeru, V. Sur les frequences propres de vibration des ions negatifs de la molecule de l'hydrogene observ6es dans le domaine des ondes eiectriques courtes. C. rend. Acad, sc, 1940, 211: 11-3.—Massey, H. S. W., & Buckingham, R. A. Long range forces between hydrogen molecules. Proc. R. Irish Acad., 1938-39, 45: Sect. A, 31-45 — Naray-Szabo, S. Beitrage zum Mechanismus der Wasser- stoffuberspannung. Zschr. phys. Chem., Abt. A, 1937-38, 181: 367-74.—Nichols, E. L., & Stanford, C. L. The hydrogen effect in certain oxides. J. Optic. Soc. America, 1936, 26: 91-8.—Parks, L. R-, & Melaven, A. D. Hide substance with hydrogen chloride and ammonia. J. Phys. Chem., 1936, 40: 471-5.—Pearson, T. G., Robinson, P. L., & Stoddart, E. M. The behaviour of metals, particularly lead and bismuth, 111 atomic hydrogen, and attempts to prepare atomic hydrogen from hydrides. Proc. R. Soc, Lond., 1933, 142: ser A 275- 85—Pietsch, E., & Lehl, H. Bildung von Metallhydnden durch atomaren Wasserstoff; Untersuchungen am System Tantal-Wasserstoff. KoUoid Zschr., 1934, 68: 226-30 — Posejpal, V. Sur la formation de l'hydrogene dans le vide. C. rend. Acad, sc, 1934, 199: 186-8—Prettre M. Etude cinetique de la reaction thermique en chaines des melanges d'hydrogene et d'oxygene. J. chim. phys., Par., 193b, 33: 189-218—Rodebush, W. H., & Buswell, A. M. Association through hydrogen. J. Phys. Chem 1939 43: 219-30.- Roginsky, S., & Zeldowitsch, J. Zur Frage ubei den Ketten- mechanismus der katalytischen Oxydation des Wasserstons. Zschr. phys. Chem., Abt. B, 1932, 18: 361.—Schwab, GM & Aeallidis. E. Ueber die Einwirkung von orgamschen Radikalen auf para-Wasserstoff. Ibid., 1938, 41: 59-70.—Sherman, A. The nature of the hydrogen bond; the role of resonance; general considerations. J. Phys. Chem., 1937, 41: 117-22.— Smith, H. A., & Napravnik, A. The photochemical oxidation ot hydrogen. J. Am. Chem. Soc, 1940, 62: 385-93.-Stanford, S. C, & Cordy, W. Spectroscopic evidence for hydrogen Dgen ana louine. ium., w->', ""• '"• • ~— , Thunberg, T. Biologische Aktivierung, Uebertragung und endgiiltige Oxydation des Wasserstoffes;Fakte und Gesichts- punkte Erg Physiol., 1937, 39: 76-116.—Wieland, H. Le nrinc oe degla migration de l'hydrogene; conference faite principe de la migration 227475__vol. 7, 4th semes ile8^11aof«CiR6nhlimiQU^de/rance' k l'w»e«nblfe annuelle le 8 juin 1938. Bull. Soc. chim. France, 1938, 5. ser., 5: 1233-42. ---- Estimation. Banerjea H. N., Bhatt, L. A., & Forster, R. B. A new method for determining hydrogen by absorption in technical gas analysis. Analyst, Lond., 1939, 64:77-86—Fischer H & Postowsky J J. Bestimmung des aktiven Wasserstoffs' im Hamin und Bilirubin, emigen ihrer Derivate und in Pyrrolen Zschr physiol. Chem., 1926, 152: 300-12.-Luttgens,' W., & £teQg.^'^ Mikro-Zerewitinoff. Biochem. Zschr., 1934, 269: 177-M—Van Slyke, D. D., & Hanke, M. E. Mano- metry analysis of gas mixtures; hydrogen bv absorption with faals picrate-palladium solution. J. Biol. Chem., 1932, 95: ---- Isotopes. See also Deuterium. Darmois, E. L'hydrogene est un melange: ortho et parahydrogene; conference faite au Conservatoire National des Arts et Metiers le 12 mai 1931. 22p. 8? Par., 1931. Bonhoeffer, K. F., & Harteck, P. Weitere Versuche mit Parawasserstoff. Naturwissenschaften, 1929, 17: 321.__ Crane, E. J. Nomenclature of the hydrogen isotopes and their compounds. Science, 1934, 80: 86-9.—Harkins, W. D. No- menclature for the isotopes of hydrogen (proto- and deuto- hydrogen) and their compounds. Ibid., 79: 138-40.—Hiede- mann, E. Die Natur des dreiatomigen Wasserstoffs. Zschr phys. Chem., Abt. A, 1931, 153: 210-40.—Rutherford. The new hydrogen. Nature, Lond., 1934, 133: 481-4.— Taylor, H. S. Protium-deuterium-tritium, the hydrogen trio. Ann. Rep. Bd Regents Smithson. Inst., 1934, 119-27. Also 8c Am. Month., 1934, 39: 364-72.—Urey, H. C. The separa- tion and properties of the isotopes of hvdrogen. Science, 1933 78: 566-71. ---- Metabolism. See also Oxidation; Respiration. Krogh, A., & Ussing, H. H. The exchange of hydrogen between the free water and the organic substances in the living organism. Skand. Arch. Physiol., Berl., 1936,75:90.-104.— Libbrecht, W., & Massart, L. L'hydrogene est un poison cellulaire. C. rend. Soc. biol., 1934, 117: 66.—Lockhart,E. E., & Potter, V. R. Studies on the mechanism of hydrogen trans- port in animal tissues; reactions involving cytochrome C. J. Biol. Chem., 1941, 137: 1-12. Also repr.—Potter, V. R. The mechanism of hydrogen transport in animal tissues. Medicine, Bait., 1940, 19: 441-74. ------ Studies on the mechanism of hydrogen transport in animal tissues; cyanide inhibition of cytochrome C reduction. J. Biol. Chem., 1941, 137: 13-20. Also repr.—Stephenson, M., & Stickland, L. H. The bacterial metabolism of molecular hvdrogen. Arch. exp. Zellforsch., 1934, 15: 55.—Tasman, A., & Pot, A.W. [For ma- tion of hydrogen from glucose and formic acid through the so-called resting colon bacteria] Antonie van Leeuwenhoek, 1935, 2: 131; 358; tab. ---- Physical properties. Balasse, G. Spectre continu atomique de l'hydrogene. Bull. Acad. Belgique, 1938, 5. ser., 24: 644-52, 3 pl.—[Barett, W. F.] Sur quelques phenomenes curieux presentes par la flamme de l'hydrogene. J. chim. med., Par., 1866, 5. ser., 2: 66.—Bay, Z., Finkelnburg, W., & Steiner, W. Ueber ein neues Bandensvstem des Wasserstoffs und seine Erzeiigungsbedin- gungen. ' Zschr. phys. Chem. Abt. B, 1930-31, 11: 351-62 — Beutler, H. Die Dissoziationswarme des Wasserstoffmolekuls H2 aus einem neuen ultravioletten Resonanzbandenzug bestimmt. Ibid., 1934, 27: 287-302. ------ Ueber das Absorptionsspektrum des Wasserstoffs; die Dissoziationswarme des Wasserstoffmolekuls H2, aus der Rotationsstruktur an der langwelligen Grenze des Absorptionskontinuums bei 850 A bestimmt. Ibid., 1935, 29: 315-27.—Borelius, G., Keesom, W. H., & Johansson, C. H. [Measurement of the thermo- electric Thomson effect in the temperature of liquid hydrogen] Versl. Akad. wet. Amsterdam, Afd. nat., 1928, 37: pt 2, 875-87.—Cremer, E. Bestimmung der Selbstdiffusion in festem Wasserstoff aus dem Reaktionsverlauf der Ortho-Para- Umwandlung. Zschr. phys. Chem., Abt. B, 1938, 39: 445-64. Selbstdiffusion in flussigem Wasserstoff. Ibid., 1939, 42: 281-7.—Delaplace, R. Hydrogene atomique et dispari- tion de l'hydrogene dans les tubes k decharge. C. rend. Acad. sc, 1936, 202: 1986.—Foresti, B. Sul comportamento elettro- motore del nichel in presenza d'idrogeno. Boll. Soc eustach., 1938 36: 79-92.—Guillien, R. Constante dieiectrique de l'hydrogene. Rev. sc, Par., 1939, 77: 575.—Gregory, H. S. The effect of temperature on the thermal conductivity and the accommodation coefficient of hydrogen. Proc. R. Soc, Lond., 1935, 149: ser. A, 35-56.—Griffin, C. W. The sorption of hydrogen by metals; temperature variation experiments. J Am Chem. Soc, 1941, 63: 2957-60.—Harteck, P.. & Schmidt, H W Die Selbstdiffusion des Wasserstoffes. Zschr. phys. Chem., Abt. B, 1933, 21: 447-58.—Hydrogen bombardment creates radioactivity. Science News Lett., 1934, 25: 190.— -59 HYDROGEN 930 HYDROGENATION lijima, S. On the adsorption of hydrogen on reduced nickel; studies at low temperatures. Rev. Phys. Chem. Japan, 1938, 12: 1—11.— I.oo, K. (). Wave-length in the spectrum of 11\.Iro- gen Abstr. Theses Lniv. Chicago, 1926-27, 5: 129-32. bunt, R. W., Meek, C. A., it Smith, E. ('. W. Ionization, excitnem and chemical reaction in uniform electric fields; the excitation of the continuous spectrum of hydrogen. Proc. R. Soc, Lond., 1937, 158: ser. A, 729-38.- Mendelssohn, K., Ruhe- mann, M.. k Simon, F. Die spezifischen Wiirmen des festen Wasser-totTs bei Hcliumtempcraturen. Zschr. phys. (hem., Abt. B, 1931-32, 15: 121-6. Messerly, <;. H. The triple point pressure of hydrogen. J. Am. Chem. Soc, 1941, 63: 1486.—Preston, W. M. Absorption of the hydrogen Une 1215.7 A. by air. Nature, Lond., 1940, 145: 623.—Richardson, O. W. Spectrum of ordinary hydrogen (H2) Ibid., 1935, 135: 99. ------ & Rymer, T. B. The spectrum of Ha; the band systems due to transitions from 4 new triplet states to 2p 311. Proc. R. Soc, Lond., 1934, 147: ser. A, 251-72.—Sandeman, I. The mathematical representation of the energy levels of the secondary spectrum of hvdrogen. Proc. R. Soc. Edinburgh, 1933, 53: 347; 1934-35, 55: pt 1, 49; 72. Schafer, K. Ueber den Dampfdiuckunterschied und die Molwiirme von Ortho- und Parawasserstoli. Zschr. phys. Chem., Abt. B, 1939, 42: 380-94.—Smith. N. D. Intensity of the continuous spectrum of hydrogen. .1. Optic Soc. America, 1938, 28: 40-5.—Suhr- mann, R., & Csesch, H. Ueber die elektrische Polarisation des an reinen Metalloberflachen adsorbierten Wasserstoffes und ihren Einfluss auf die Rekombination von Wasserstoffatomen. Zschr. phys. Chem., Abt. B, 1935, 28: 215-35- Taylor. H. S., & Strother, C O. Adsorption of hydrogen by zinc oxide, zinc chroniite, and zinc oxide-molybdenum oxide. J. Am. Chem. Soc, 1934, 56: 586-90.—Venable, W. M. Analysis of the spectrum of hydrogen. J. Optic. Soc. America, 1937, 27: 155-8.—Werner, W., & Keesom, W. H. [Variation of the dielectric constant of Uquid and solid hydrogen with tempera- ture] Versl. Akad. wet. Amsterdam, Afd. nat., 1926, 35: pt 1, 18-25.—Wiebe, R., & Gaddy. V. L. The solubility of hydrogen in water at 0, 50, 75 and 100° from 25 to 1000 atmos- pheres. J. Am. Chem. Soc, 1934, 56: 76-9. HYDROGENASE. See also Dehydrogenase; Hydroxylysine. Bovarnick, M. Preparation of cell-free solutions of hydro- genase. Proc. Soc. Exp. Biol., N. Y., 1941, 47: 191-3.— Dann, W. J. The temperature coefficients and energy exchanges of the citric acid dehydrogenase of cucumber seeds. Biochem. .1., bond., 1931, 25: 177-89.—Green, I). E., it Stickland, L. H. Studies on reversible dehydrogenase systems; the reversibUity of the hydrogenase svstem of Bact. col. Ibid., 1934, 28: 898- 900.—Lee, S. B., Phelps. A. S., & Wilson, P. W. Hydrogenase in biological nitrogen fixation. J. Bact., Bait., 1941, 42: 142.— Phelps, A. S., <& Wilson, P. W. Occurrence of hydrogenase in nitrogen-fixing organisms. Proc. Soc. Exp. Biol., N. Y., 1941 47: 473-6.—Stephenson, M. Formic Hvdrogenlvse. Lig Enzymforsch., 1937, 6: 139-56. ------ & Stickland, L. H Hydrogenlyases; bacterial enzymes liberating molecular hydro- gen. Biochem. J., Lond., 1932, 26: 712. ------ Hydrogenase; the bacterial formation of methane by the reduction of one- carbon compounds by molecular hydrogen. Ibid., 1933, 27: 1517-27.— Uudkin, J. Hydrogenlyases; some factors concerned in the production of the enzymes. Ibid., 1932, 26: 1859-71.— Wilson. J. B., & Lee, S. B. Properties of hydrogenase in Azotobactcr. J. Bact., Bait., 1942, 43: 7.—Woods, D. D. Hvdrogcnlvases; the synthesis of formic acid by bacteria. Biochem. J.. Lond., 1936, 30: 515-27. HYDROGENATION. See also Hydrogenase. Huber, K. H. *Biologische Wasserstoffak- zeptoren. 24p. 8? Miinch., 1934. Reichel, G. *Studien fiber Wasserstoffakzep- torcn. 20p. 8? Munch., 1933. Adkins, H. Quantitative hydrogenation at 100-300 atmos- pheres. J. Am. Chem. Soc, 1933, 55: 4272-5. ----— k Cconradt, H. L. The selective hydrogenation of derivatives of pyrrole, indole, carbazole and acridine. Ibid., 1941, 63: 1563- 70.—Bergstrom, F. W., & Carson, J. F. AlkaU and alkaline earth metals as catalysts in the hydrogenation of organic com- pounds. Ibid., 2934-6.—Bok, L. D. ('., & Geib, K. H. Ueber den Wasserstoffaustausch in wasserigen Losungen von Essig- saure und Acetat. Zschr. phys. Chem., Abt. A, 1938-39, 183: 353-70.—Breteau, P. Methode d'hydrogenation par le cal- cium et l'alcool absolu. J. pharm. chim., Par., 1911, 7. ser., 3: 580-2.-—Catalytic hydrogenation. In Catalysis (Berkman, S. [et al.]) N. Y., 1940, 553-86.—Klar, R. Ueber die Austausch- barkeit von Wasserstoffatomen in organischen Verbindungen mit den Wasserstoffatomen des Wassers. Zschr. phys. Chem., Abt. B, 1934. 26: 335-42.—Lipschitz, W. Bemerkungen zu der Abhanrilung von Prof. H. Winterstein: Zur Kenntnis der biologischen Bedeutung von Wasserstoffacceptoren. Arch, ges Physiol., 1923, 198: 648-50.—Nord, F. F. Investigation of hydrogenation catalyst preparations. Yearb. Am. PhUos. Soc, 1941, 1US-1C—Palfray, L. Hydrogenation catalytique avec enregistrement de temperature et pression; appUcation k quel- ques chalnes aUphatiques. BuU. Soc chim. France, 1940, 5. ser., 7: 401-6 (microfilm) —Stern, I,. S. A propos de la specificite des accepteurs d'hydrogene. Bull. biol. med. exp. URSS, 1936, 1: 330.—Weill, P., it Kayser. K. Hydrogenation catalytique de quelques epox>de-. Bull. Soc. chim. France, 1936, 5. ser., 3: I 841-4.—Winterstein. H. /Cur Kenntnis der biologischen Bedeutung von \\ asserstollacceptoren. Arch. ges. Physiol,. 1923, 198: 504-12. HYDROGEN ion concentration. See Acid-base equilibrium. HYDROGEN peroxide. See Oxide, Peroxide. HYDROGEN sulfide. See Sulfur hydrogen. HYDROGRAPHY. See also Geography; Hydrology; River; Water, etc. Urbain, P. Introduction k l'etude hydrogeologique des Pyrenees francaises. Ann. Inst, hydr., Par., 1924, 2: 207; 1926, 4: 48, 2 ch. HYDROGYMNASTICS. See Gymnastics; Massage. HYDROIDEA. See also Coelenterata. Fraser, C. McL. New species of hydroids from the Puerto Rican region. 7p. 8? Wash., D. C, 1937. Goldin, A. Factors influencing regeneration and polarity determination in Tubularia crocea. Biol. Bull., 1912, 82: 243-54. HYDROLOGY. See also Balneology; Climatotherapy; Hydro- biology; Physiotherapy. Bardet, G. Hydrologie generale. Ann. Inst, hydr., Par., 1923, 1: 72; 136; 293.—Development (The) of hydrology. .1. Am. M. Ass., 1936, 106: 1750.—Horton, R. E. Hydrologie research. Science, 1937, 86: 527-30.—Lepape, A. L'oeuvre hydrologique de Ch. Moreau et le probleme de l'origine de ['helium des gaz naturels. Ann. Inst, hydr., Par., 1932-33, 8: 157-78.—Loeper, M., & Mougeot, A. La liposeiection des cations, methode nouvelle en hydrologie experimentale. C. rend. Acad, sc, 1932, 194: 575. ---- medical. See also Bath; Mineral waters, etc. Archives op medical hydrology; being the journal of the International Society of Medical Hydrology. Lond., v.l, 1922- [International] Congres international d'hydrologie et de climatologie; deuxieme session, Paris, 1889; programme des seances et des excursions. 4p. 24cm. Par., 1889. International congress op medical hy- drology. 7. Congr., Venezia, 1900. Compte rendu. 1041p. 20cm. Venez., 1906. International congress op medical hy- drology. 14. Congr., Toulouse, Oct. 4 S, 1933. Rapports: Congres international d'hydrologie, de climatologie [&c] 538p. 21^cm. Par., 1933. ---- Discussion des rapports, communica- tions, comptes rendus. 594p. 21Ucm. Par., 1934. Kampe, R. Hydrologie, mit besonderer Berucksichtigung der Mineralquellen. p.424-86. 2o1km. Berl., 1940. Santamarina, V. Hidrologia y climatologfa medicas. 296p. 8? Habana, 1937. Schivardi, P. Rivista idrologica. 32p. 24cm. Milano, 1867. Seligmanx. Jahrbuch fiir Badewesen, 1932. 347p. 8? Munch. [1932] HYDROLOGY 931 HYDROLYSIS Symons, G. J. On the proceedings of the International Congress of Hydrology and Clima- tology at Biarritz, October, 1886. p.45-58 24cm. [Lond.] 1887. Vinaj. II dottore Plinio Schivardi della Gazzetta degli Ospitali e le sue note critiche sull'Associazione idrologica. 34p. 24cm Tor [1890] Assemblee generale des membres de l'lnternational Society of Medical Hydrology, Toulouse, 6 octobre 1933. C. rend Congr. internat. hydr. clim. geol. med. (1933) 1934, 14. Congr 89.—Avant-programme du XVP Congrds international d'hy- drologie, de chmatologie et de geologie medicales; Strasbourg Faculte de medecine, 8, 9, 10 et 11 octobre 1939. Nutrition' Par., 1939, 9: 79.—Benade, W. Einige Erliiuterungen zu dem Bericht iiber die Arbeiten des Internationalen Peloid-Komitees Balneologe, 1938, 5: 419-22.—Boudry, A. A rebours de certains dogmes en hydrologie et climatologie. Gaz med France, 1938, 45: Suppl., Therm., 11.—Calthrop, L. C. e! The scientific basis of the practice of medical hydrology Proc R. Soc. M., Lond., 1927-28, 21: Sect. Balneob, 1-7.—'Chiray La specialisation en hydrologie. Gaz. med. France, 1938, 45: Suppl., Therm., 3.—Congresso nazionale della Associazione medica itaUana di idro-climatologia, talassologia e terapia fisica. Riv. idroclim., 1937, 48: 89.—Cornet, L. Une familie d'hydromineralogistes: les Bordeu. Progr. med., Par., 1926, 41: (Suppl. illust.) 81.—De Gorsse. B. Un hydrologue in- connu du XVIII8 siecle Lamoignon de Malesherbes ministre et defenseur de Louis XVI. Bull. Soc. fr. hist, med., 1935, 29: 225-8.—Fortescue-Fox, R. The teaching of physical medicine with especial reference to medical hydrology. Commun. Congr. internat. physiother. (1930) 1931, 5. Congr., Sect, gen., No. 7, 45-50 [Discussion] C. rend., 132-4.—Foveau de Courmelles. L'hydrologie beige et francaise. J. med. Paris, 1937, 57: 207-13.—Francon, F. Peierinages, ceremonies, banquets et receptions (Congres international d'hydrologie, Belgrade) Presse therm, clim., 1936, 77: 713-6. ------ Le Cinquantenaire des Congres internationaux d'hydrologie, de climatologie et de geologie medicales (Biarritz, 1886-Belgrade, 1936) Presse med;, 1937, 45: 34-6.—International Society of Medical Hydrology; officers, members, rules. Arch. M. Hydr., Lond., 1938, 16: Suppl., 1-6.—Jaloustre. De la necessite d'un laboratoire d'hydrologie dans chaque station hydro- minerale. Vie med., 1924, 5: 1505-8.—Matsuo, T. The present state of medical hvdrology in the countries represented. Arch. M. Hydr., Lond.,'1931, 9: 385-7.—Merklen, R. Les enseignements climatiques et thermaux des congres de Londres, Oxford et Bath, 1938. Presse therm, dim., 1938, 79: 309-13. ------ L'orientation actuelle de l'hydrologie et de la clima- tologie. Ibid., 333-8.—Narciso, A. Evolution de 1'hydrologie scientifique au Portugal. Ibid., 1936, 77: 513.—Piccinini, P. Basi scientifiche e importanza pratica deU'idrologia. Riv. idroclim., 1927, 38: 39-46.—Pisani, S. CUnica idrologica e scienza. Ibid., 1934, 14: 9-13.—Quatorze Congres Interna- tional d Hydrologie, de Climatologie et de Geologie Medicales. Presse therm. cUm., 1933, 74: 781-811—Rathery. F. Quinze congres international d'hydrologie, de climatologie et de geologie medicales, Belgrade. Paris med., 1936, 102: annexe, 336-9.—Ray, M. B. The role of hydrology in medical practice. Postgrad. M. J., Lond., 1930, 5: 115; 137.—Rimattei, F. Hydrologie et hydrognosie. Gaz. med. France, 1940, 47: 189.—Silva Carvalho. Contribuicoes para a historia da hidrologia portuguesa; Caldas de Monchique. Lisboa med., 1934, 11: 427; 771.—Societe d'hydrologie et de chmatologie m6dicales de Paris. Presse therm. cUm., 1935, 76: 11; 78.— Valenti, A. La prima Cattedra di idrologia medica neUa R. University di Roma. Riv. idroclim., 1939, 50: 315. HYDROLYSATE. See also Hydrolysis. Brazier, M. A. B. A new method for the separation of the products of hydrolysis. Biochem. J., Lond., 1930, 24: 1188- 98.—Egoroff, A., & Laptewa-Popowa, M. Einfluss nieder- molekularer Tierorganhydrolysate auf das Retikulo-Endothel und die Phagozytose. Acta med. scand., 1935-36, 87: 345-57.— Engeland, R., & Biehler. W. Isolement de nouveaux consti- tuants dans les hydrolysats chlorhydriques de l'61astine. Bull. Soc chim. biol., Par., 1937, 19: 100-8.—Kazakov, I. N. [Effect of products of extensive hvdrolysis on the normal and diseased constitution] J. Physiol. USSR. 1936, 21: 1041.—Marchal, J. G. Les hydrolats; quelques essais concernant leur bactenologie et les modifications qu'ils subissent sous Taction des rnicro- organismes. Bull, sc pharm., Par., 1938, 45: 59; 123.— Riconi, M. Azione biologica di idroUzzati di organi e di proteine; il valore emopoietico di idrolizzati di emoglobina. Boll. Soc. ital. biol. sper., 1932, 7: 1160-3.----— Azione biologica di idrolizzati di organi e di proteine; azione di prodotti sintesiformativi dell'emoglobina introdotti per via parenteral. Ibid., 1163-6.—Roffo, A. H. Ruckgang und Schwund von bosartigen Geschwtilsten der Ratte durch das Hydrolysat des quergestreiften Muskels. Deut. med. Wschr., 1938, 64: 959-64. Also Lancet, Lond., 1938, 2: 184-7.—Steppuhn, O. A. Wir- kungsmechanismus ton Organ- und Gewebehydrolyseproduk- ten. Proc. Internat. Physiol. Congr. (1935) 1938, 15. Congr., 576. HYDROLYSIS. See also names of hydrolytic enzymes as Pepsin, etc.; also under names of hydrolvzed substances as Glucoside; Protid, etc Abdon N. O., & Nielsen, N. A. [Effect of strophantin and acetylcholin on enzymic kreatin-phosphoric-acid-hydrolysis] Hospitalstidende, 1938, 81: 288-91.—Arrhenius, S. Ueber die Dissociation der in Wasser gelosten Stoffe. Zschr. phys Chem., 1887, 1: 631-48. ------ Ueber die Hydrolyse von Salzen schwacher Sauren und schwacher Basen. Ibid., 1894 13: 407-11.—Bamann, E., & Schmeller, M. Zur Kinetik der ksterhydrolyse durch Enzyme. Zschr. phvsiol. Chem , 1929 183: 149-67.—Barkan, G., & Kingisepp, G. Weitere Unter- suchungen uber Jodeiweisshydrolyse. Arch, exp Path Berl., 1933-34, 174: 444-52.—Bayliss, W. M. The dissociation of salts of weak acids with weak bases. Arch, fisiol., Fir 1909, 7: 357-68.—Birkhauser, H., & Siillmann, H. Verglei- chende Untersuchungen uber die enzymatische Hydrolyse von Acetylaneurin und Acetylcholin. Schweiz. med. Wschr., 1940, 70: 34-6.—Cattaneo, C. Sulla idrolisi enzimatica dell'acido melibioncarbonico. Boll. Soc. ital. biol. sper., 1936, 11: 902-4.—Cohen, E. Experimentaluntersuchung iiber die Dissociation geloster Korper in Alkohol-Wassergemischen Zschr. phys. Chem., 1898, 25: 1-15.—Diehl, F., & Lauersen, F. Ueber die hydrolysierbare reduzierende Substanz des Blutes; die Methode der fraktionierten Hydrolyse. Zschr. ges. exp Med., 1935, 96: 625-39.—Glimm, E., & Grimm, R. Salz- hydrolyse der Starke. Biochem. Zschr., 1928, 197: 445-59.— Guillaume, A., & Tanret, G. Sur l'hydrolyse des glucosides, et de quelques composes organiques, par les rayons ultra- violets. BuU. Soc. chim. biol., Par., 1936, 18: 556-72.— Jander, G., & Jahr, K. F. Neuere Anschauungen iiber die Hydrolyse anorganischer Salze und die Chemie der hoch- molekularen Hydrolyseprodukte (einschliesslich der Iso- und Heteropolyverbindungen) Kolloid. Beihefte, 1935, 41: 1; 297- 1935-36, 43: 295.—Kroepelin, H. Eine Demonstration der Membranhydrolyse an Indikatorfolien. Kolloid Zschr., 1928, 44: 188-90.—Kuhlenbeck, H., & Voit, K. Beobachtungen am Kernbild nach Hydrolyse und nach Nuklealfarbung; weitere Beitrage zur Nuklealreaktion. Anat. Anz., 1932-33, 74: 1-20, pl.—Planck, M. Ueber die Hypothese der Dissociation der Salze in sehr verdiinnten Losungen. Zschr. phys. Chem., 1888, 2: 343.—Rabinovitch, B. S., & Winkler, C. A. The hydrolysis of acid amides in concentrated hydrochloric acid solutions. Canad. J. Res., 1942, 20: Sect. B, 73-81.—Rimbach, E. Dissociation und optische Drehung aktiver Salzlosungen. Zschr. phys. Chem., 1895, 16: 671-6.—Sackur, O. Geschmol- zene Salze als Losungsmittel; der Dissociationsgrad geloster Salze. Ibid., 1913, 82: 297-314.—Srinivasan, M., & Sreeni- vasaya, M. Dilatometric studies in the hydrolysis of the 2, 5- diketopiperazines and polypeptides; alkali hydrolysis of glycine and alanine anhydrides. J. Biol. Chem., 1934, 105: 563-70. Also repr.—Warner, R. C. The kinetics of the hydrolysis of urea and of arginine. Ibid., 1942, 142: 705-23.—Wiedemann, E. Ueber die Hypothese der Dissociation der Salze in sehr verdiinnten Losungen. Zschr. phys. Chem., 1888, 2: 241-4. HYDROMANCY. See also Divination. Delobson, D. Les procedes divinatoires des Bagba (Devins) au Mossi. Rev. anthrop., Par., 1933, 43: 182-212.—Lintott, G. A. M. Water divining. Guy's Hosp. Gaz., Lond., 1933, 47: 282. HYDROMEDUSAE. Uchida, T. Beitrage zur Kenntnis der japanischen Hydro- medusen. Zool. Anz., 1930, 88: 329-35. HYDROMETER. Gaehr, P. F. A. Angstrom's total immersion hydrometer. Rev. Sc. Instrum., 1933, n. ser., 4: 138-41.—Pieraerts, J. Un hydrotimetre a double graduation. Ann. pharm., Louvain, 1905, 11: 473-6.—[Verification of Baumd's araeometer] Ny pharm. tid., Kbh., 1878, 10: 71-6. HYDROMETRA. See under Uterus. HYDROMYELIA. See under Spinal cord. HYDRONEPHROSIS. See under Kidney. HYDROPATHY. See also Hydrotherapy. Herrmann, E. *Die Methode des Vincenz Priessnitz und ihre Bedeutung fiir seine Zeit und die Gegenwart. 35p. 8? Erlangen, 1936. HYDROPATHY 932 HYDROPS Kxeipp, S. My water-cure. 33. ed. 395p. S? Worishofen, 1891. ---- [The same] My \vater cure; as tested through more than 30 vears; transl. by A. deF. 6. ed. 282p. 8? Edinb. [193?] ----[The same] Meine Wasserkur. 352p. 20cm. Miinch., 1939. ---- Das grosse Kneippbuch; ein Volksbuch fiir Gesunde und Kranke; hrsg. von Bonifaz Reile. 1065p. 8? Miinch., 1935. Rogier di Beaufort, C. L'idropatia razionale teorico-pratica; manuale. 93p. 18^cm. Tor., 1 s57. Schalle, A. Die Kneippkur die Kur der Erfolge. 3. Aufl. 631p. 8? Miinch., 1935. Schalle, F. *Ueber das Verhalten der Warmestrahlung des menschlichen Korpers nach Kneipp'schen hydrotherapeutischen Anwendun- gen. 41p. 23cm. Munch., 1937. Wohlwend, A. *Ueber die Hautwarme- abstrahlung nach Kneippschen Giissen [Miin- chen] 20p. 8? Friedb., K. Bauer, 1936. Bottenberg, H, Die Behandlung kranker Kinder nach dem Kneippschen Naturheilverfahren. Hippokrates, Stuttg., 1936, 7- 268-73.—Flamm, S. Zur Biologie und Praxis der Kneipp- schen Wasserheilkunde. Ibid., 202-6. ------ Beitrag zur Krankheitslehre Sebastian Kneipps. Ibid., 1937, 8: 590-4.— Haindl, L. Was brachte Kneipp der Wasserheilkunde Neues. Fortsch. Med., 1935, 53: 561.—Hoff, A. Das Kneippsche Naturheilverfahren. Naturarztl. Rdsch., 1937, 9: 139-53. ------ Ein vielseitiges und wertvolles Heilmittel: Die kalte Waschung nach Kneipp. Ibid., 342-8.—John Wesley's wap i -cure methods. Good Health, 1937, 72: 43.—Neugebauer, H. Auseinandersetzung zwischen Schulmedizin und Volks- lieilkundeam An fang des 19. Jahrhunderts unter besonderer Berucksichtigung der Hydrotherapie. Hippokrates, Stuttg., 1939 10: 650; 683.—Pitcairn-Knowles, G. Curing with water. In Health & Nat. Cure Handb. (Nat. Cure Ass.). Lond., 1932, 2: 92-9.- Pope, C. Hydrotherapy, lay und medical. Phys. Ther 1930 48: 139- 50. Pumpc, H. Anweiiduiigeii nach Kneipp. Naturarztl. Rdsch., 1937, 9: 153 S. - -Riddell, W. R. The original hydropath, Dr James Cunie, and In- American repercussions. Med. J. & Rec, N. Y.. 1931. 132: 55S 60. Also repr.—Scholz, A. Wissenschaftliche Grundlagen der Kneipp'schen Hydrotherapie. Wien. med. Wschr., 1939, 89: 517-22.—Thoma, K. Kneippkur als Erlebnis. Hippokrates, Stuttg 1938, 9: 1039-42. - Tiegel, W. Badeanwendungen im Naturheilverfahren. Zsehr. iirztl. Fortbild., 1939, 36: 388- !)2.—Zarlenga. R. L'idropatia e qualche altra pretesa novitsi rivendicata agli antichi. Filiatre sebezio, Nap., 1844, 28: 54-0. HYDROPERICARDIUM. See under Heart sac. HYDROPERITONEIM. See Ascites. HYDROPHILUS. Guareschi, C. Sulla natura del secreto delle ectadenie di Hydrophilus piceus; ricerche microchimiche e chimiche. Riv. biol., 1937, 23: 353-64, 2 pl. HYDROPHTHALMOS. See Glaucoma, congenital. HYDROPNEUMOTHORAX. See under Thorax. HYDROPS. See also Anasarca; Edema; Erythroblastosis; also names of organs and parts affected. For epidemic dropsy see Beri-Beri. H\rms, J. *Ueber die Beziehungen von Hydrops. 19p. 23cm. Kiel, 1936. Roessler, G. *Alte und neue Ansichten iiber Hydrops, Xephropathie, Eklampsie und deren Behandlung [Munchen] 48p. 8? Berl., 1927. Angrisani, B. Caso d'idrope cistico. Filiatre sebezio, Nap.. 1842, 23: 201.—Bang. Nuovo metodo per trattare le j idxopisie. Ibid., 1831, 3: 157.—Bornstein, R. [Intermittent dropsy] Polska gaz. lek., 1931, 10: 758.—Cadeac k Morot. Kaux-aux-jambes chez le boeuf. Bull. Soc sc. vit. Lyon, 1809, 2: 66-9.—Comrie, J. I). Remarks on historical aspects of ideas regarding dropsy. Brit. M. J., 1928, 2: 229 32.— Cusieri, D. Relazione d'un caso di lenta angioitc con ascite, preceduta da esame critieo sullo stato attuale della nosologia liguardo a questo genere d'infermit&; alcune cosiderazioni sull'idrope compongono questo. Gazz. toscana sc. med. fis., 1850, 8: 272-7.—Engle, H. M. Homeopathic therapeutic approach to dropsy. J. Am. Inst. Homeop., 1939, 32: 732-5.— Federigo, G. Conforto pegl'idropici, ossia storie di parecehi casi d'idrope di un esito fortunato o di un notevole migliora- mento. Gior. progr. pat., Venez., 1838, 9: 344-83.—Fleckseder, R. Ueber Entstehung und Behandlung der Wasser^uc In. Karlsbad, arztl. Voitr. (1937) 1939, 16: 244-57.—Folinea. Idrope cistico. Ann. clin. Osp. incurab., Nap., 1836, 2: -12*. Foster, N. B. The treatment of common forms of dropsy. N. York State J. M., 1933, 33: 1373-6.—Gorini, F. Caso di idropisia anasarcatico-meccanica, svilluppatasi nei quinto mese di gravidanza, superata felicemente col parto naturale nei sesto mese, dietro l'azione di una dram ma di segala cornuta. Gior. progr. pat., Venez., 1844, ser. 2, 6: 402-14.- Gorodner, A. Las protefnas sanguineas en algunos sindromes ludropigenos. Prensa med. argent, 1941, 28: pt 1, 652-8.--Groedel. Die Behandlung des Hydrops mit Reduktion der I liissigkeits- Aufnahme. Rapp. Congr. internat. physiother., 1910, 3. Congr., 488-501.—Hantschmann, L. Die Entstehung und Behandlung der Wassersueht. Ther. Gegenwart, 1939, 80: 254-8—Hon", F. Die Wassersueht. Munch, med. Wschr., 1928, 75:829-32.—Hiibencr, G. Die Behandlung des Hydrops. Zschr. Kreislaufforsch., 1929, 21: 98 102. Huysinga. J. K. [Marked hydrops in an infant] Ned. tschr. geneesk., 1939, 83: 3674.—Kestermann, E., & Schleining, T. Da.-i Verhalten des unmerklichen Gewichtsverlustes bei hydropischen Erkrarikuu- gen. Deut. Arch. klin. Med., 1936-37, 179: 609-16. Klodt, W. Die Bedeutung der relativen Natriumhilanz im I Tin fiir die Therapie und den Verlauf hvdropischer Zustiinde. Fortsch. Then, 1936, 12: 646-53.—Kossler. Ueber die Behandlung des Hydrops. Mitt. Ver. Aerzte Steiermark, 1925, 62: 141-8.— Lenzner, R. Die Wassersueht. Mitt. Biochem., 1933, 40: 226-9.—Lombard. Hydropisie ascite gu^rie par les injections iodees. J. med. Toulouse, 1864, 4. ser., 3: 129-37.—McCann, W. S. The management of dropsies. N. York Stale ,1. M., 1928, 28: 1395-8.—Magnus-Levy, A. Natrium- und Kalium- salze bei Wassersueht. Zschr. klin. Med., 1928, 107: 659-70. Marvin, H. M. The therapy of dropsy. Ind. M. Gaz., 1940, 75: 492-7. Also J. Am. M. Ass., 1940, 114: 757-63. Also Rev. As. mid. argent., 1940, 54: 678-85. Also Bol. Of. san. panamer., 1941, 20: 341-57.—Marx, H. Die Wassersueht und ihre Behandlung. Zschr. iirztl. Fortbild., 1935, 32: 465-8.— Neuburger, M. Oldest investigations on origin of dropsy. Med. Rev. of Rev., 1930, 36: 497-501.--Pavesi, C. Presenza della digitalina, acido ippurico, e filnina, nelle orine d'un malato d'idropisia, sotto la cura colla digitale purpurea. Gior. farm, chim., Tor., 1867, 16: 13-6.—Roumiantzev, F. [Dropsy in children] Pediatria, Moskva, 1927, 11: 3-13.—Roux, P. M. Observation sur la gudrison d'une hydropique, par le sulfate magndsien. Observ. provenc sc. mfid., 1821, 1: 120-6. Sachs, H. Hydrops und Wetter. Zbl. Gyn., 1929, 53: 2275- 8.—Saxl, P. Ueber Wassersueht und ihre Behandlung. Wien. klin. Wschr., 1924, 37: [Beil.] 1-12.—Schwarte, F. Meine Erfahrungen bei Wassersueht mit Nephrisan in fiinfzehn- jahriger Praxis. Deut. Aerzte Ztg, 1935, 10: No. 419.— Schwenkenbecher, A. Die Wasserabgabe der Haut bei hydropischen Zustanden. Verh. Deut. Ges. inn. Med., 1926, 38. Kongr., 302-5.—Terrone, G. Storia di due casi d'idropisie felicemente terminate. Ann. clin. Osp. incurab., Nap., 1835, 1: 178-85.—Treatment of dropsy. Lancet, Lond., 1940, 1: 929.—Veil, W. H. Moderne Gesichtspunkte in der Pathologie und Therapie der Wassersueht. Zschr. arztl. Fortbild., 1925, 22: 494; 522.—Volhard, F. Tratamiento de la hidropesfa. Dia med., B. Air., 1939, 11: 100-5.—Winternitz, M. Treat- ment of dropsy; with mercurial diuretics and urea. Lancet, Lond., 1940, 1: 879.—Zimmermann. K. Zum Problem patho- logischer Graviditatshydropsien; kritische Erwagungen und eigene Beobachtungen. Wien. tierarztl. Mschr., 1936, 23: 577-87. HYDROQUINONE. See Quinol. HYDRORRHEA. See under organ affected as Uterus, Hydror- rhea; also Otorrhea; Rhinorrhea, etc. HYDROTHERAPY. See also Balneology; Bath; Cold, Therapeutic use; Douche; Hydrology, medical; Hydropathy; Mineral waters, etc. Morselli, E. L'idroterapia moderna e i suoi intenti. lip. 22^cm. Fir., 1887. Mtjro, V. Nozioni fondaiyentali di idro- terapia igienica e profilattica. 61p. 21}£cm. Nap., 1883. HYDROTHERAPY 933 HYDROTHERAPY Allman, D. B. Hydrotherapy and its use at the Betty Bacharach Home. J.'M. Soc. N. Jersey, 1938, 35: 735-7.— Baruch. S. Last testament on hydrotherapy. Med. Rev. of Rev., 1929, 35: 97-9.—Behrend, H. J. Modern hydrotherapy. Arch. Phys. Ther., 1937, 18: 146-53—Brownsberger, J. F. Hydrotherapy. South. M. & S., 1934, 96: 1-3.—Coulter, J. S. Hydrotherapy. In Art & Sc. Nurs. (Rothweiler, E. L., & White, J. M.) 2. ed., Phila., 1941, 489-96.—Deschamps. Quelques notions d'hydroth6rapie scientifique. C. rend. Congr. internat. physiother. (1905) 1906, 1. Congr., 69.—Fox, R. F. Hydrotherapy. In Orthop. Surg. (Jones), Lond., 1921, 2: 581-97.—Hiiberlin. C. Thalassotherapie und Hydrotherapie in Verbindung mit derselben. Arch. M. Hydr., Lond., 1927, 5: 273-6.—Hauffe, G. Was muss der Arzt von der Hydro- therapie wissen? Zschr. arztl. Fortbild., 1926, 23: 345;' 383. Also Cr6n. med. mex., 1928, 27: 38-44.—Hinsdale, G. Medical hvdrologv in the United States. Brit. J. Phys. M., 1935-36, 10: 83; 98.—Idroterapia. Progr. ter., Milano, 1905, 151-94 — McClellan, W. S. Hydrotherapy and balneotherapy. In Modern Med. Ther. (Barr, D. P.) Bait., 1940, 1: 415-45.— Nylin, J. B. The use of water in therapeutics. Arch. Phys. Ther., 1932, 13: 261-72.—Ray, M. B. Hydrotherapy. In Brit,,Encycl. M. Pract. (Rolleston, H.) Lond., 1937, 6: 573- 602. ------ The therapeutic pool. Lancet, Lond., 1940, 1: 683-5.—Ruhmkorff, R. H. Modern hydrotherapy. Am. Med., 1929, 35: 443-5.—Spann, R. L. Hydrotherapy. Eclect. M. J., 1934, 94: 402-6.—State medical legislation. J. Am. M. Ass., 1941, 116: 2414.—Sullivan, A. G. Hydrotherapy. Pract. Libr. M. & S., N. Y., 1935, 8: 85-96.—Varanini, M. A propo- sito di un articolo di La Presse Thermale et Climatique. Riv. idroclim., 1937, 48: 282-6.—Wolf, H. F. Hydrotherapy. In Ther. Int. Dis. (Blumer, G., et al.) N. Y., 1940, 1: 108-40 — Woodbury, F. T. Hydrotherapy: a cheap and efficient remedy. Clin. M. & S., 1933, 40: 306.—Wright, R. Hydrotherapy. Cyclop. Med. (Piersol-Bortz) Phila., 1939, 7: 342-71. Also Collect. Lect. Metrop. State Hosp., Waltham, 1941, 467-71. ---- Apparatus. Fenton, C. J. Thermobath cabinet. U. S. Patent Off., 1940, no. 2,199,285.—Hilgert, R. Heilbader im Kranken- hausneubau Huyssenstift Essen. Zschr. ges. Krankenhauswes., 1937, 117-9.—Hillebrand. W. E. Applicator for thermal vapor treatment of individual parts of the human body. U. S. Patent Off., 1941, No. 2,265,484.—Rocke, W. Hydro- therapy circulator. Ibid., 1942, No. 2,280,979.—Solley, A. C. Apparatus for hydrotherapy. Ibid., 1937, No. 2,091,167 — Westphalen, F. Ueber Warmebehandlung gynakologischer Erkrankungen mit der neuen Heisswasserblase Gynotherm. Miinch. med. Wschr., 1928, 75: 1169. ---- History, and teaching Franco, D. L'idrojatria nella storia della scuola medica napolitana. 21p. 24cm. Milano, PSYCHROLTJPOSIA VETTJS RENOVATA, IAM RE- tocta; wieder aufgewarmt Alt- Kalt Bad u. Trmcken. 36p. 8? Schweidnitz, 1738. Reis, V. van der. Die Geschichte der Hydro- therapie von Hahn bis Priessnitz. 8? Berl., 1914. „. ,. Gabbi, U. Lo sviluppo storico dell'idroterapia. Gior elm. med 1927,8:62-7. Also Am. J. Phys. Ther., 1933, 10: 9-14 — Garrigues, A. Un chapitre de la therapeutique scandmave aux temps barbares; les eaux et les sources. Vie med., 1934, 15: 27-30.—Gasperini. G. L'Asclepio di Coo e la sua importanza nella storia della idrologia medica. Riv. stor. sc. med., 1928, 19: 199-208.—Idroterapia (L') nella storia. Minerva med., Tor 1940 31: pt 2, varia, 258-68 (microfilm)—Jones, C. E. Texts and documents; an essay on the external use of water, by Tobias Smollett. Bull. Inst. Hist. M., Bait., 1935, 3: 31-82- Kellogg J. H. History of the remedial use of water in modern times Good Health, 1937, 72: 74; 110; 140—Kuthy, l>. p. L'insegnamento grafico della idroterapia e della climatologia. C. rend. Congr. internat. hydr. clim. geol. ther. (1905) 1906, 7 Congr 118-34.—Onoranze a due medici piomen dell idro- logia Alberto Riva e Cesare Cattaneo. Med. ital., 1933, 14: 492-508—Piccinini, P. I contributi italiani aUa idrochma- tologia. ' Riv. idroclim., 1934, 45: 172-86.-Plate. E. Trend of hydrotherapy in Germany. Arch. Phys. Ther. 1933 14: 536—Rebucci, A. M. Sulla necessity di diffondere fra i medici le cognizioni di idrologia terapeutica. Riv. idroclim., 1936 47- II —Schivardi, P. Studi d'idrologia medica. Ann. med.'pubb., Roma, 1874, 308; 1875 append. 1-8-Stewart, C. E. History of hydrotherapy. Med Life 1926 30. 101- 10 —Tienes, A. Aus Priessnitzens Werkstatt (1799-18.>1) Naturarztl. Rdsch., 1937, 9: 72-8.—Vinaj, A La terapia idrica fra i greci ed i romani. Riv. stor. sc. med., 1920, it. 173-88. ---- Indications. Feer E Wasseranwendungen beim gesunden und kranken Kinde. 32p. 24Kcm. Jena, 1938. Arnoult. Un peu d'hydrotherapie en veterinaire. Bull. Soc centr. med. vet., Par., 1898, 52: 105-9.—Bischoff, H. Hydrotherapie im Kindesalter. Fortschr. Ther., 1932, 8: 74-9.—Brauchle, A. Wann machen wir kalte und wann warme Aufschlage? Med. Welt, 1934, 8: 729-31.—Gabbi. L'idro- terapia nelle malattie acute. Gazz. osp., 1927, 48: 1009-12. Also Gior. cUn. med., 1927, 8: 633-9.—Gourdon. Emploi de l'eau froide dans plusieurs maladies chirurgicales. J. mid. vit., Lyon, 1845, 1: 393; 489.—Groh, W. Wasseranwendungen in der Praxis. Ther. Gegenwart, 1935, 76: 264-7.—Hauffe, G. Hydrotherapie. Med. Welt, 1929, 3: 1801-4. ------ Hydrotherapie im Kindesalter. Zbl. ges. Kinderh., 1929-30, 23: 657-65.—Hugonot & Andrieu. L'utilisation des ressources hydro-min6rales francaises par le service de sant6 miUtaire. Rapp. Congr. internat. hydr. cUm., 1933, 14. Congr., 483- 516.—Idroterapia (L') nei bambini. Progr. ter., Milano, 1903, 108-15.—Landouzy, L., & Heitz, J. Le traitement thermal; ses indications; ses risques. Tr. Internat. Congr. Med., 1913, Sect. V, Ther., pt 1, 23-45 [Discussion] pt 2, 319.— Llewellyn, L. J. Preventive hydrotherapy. Arch. M. Hydr., Lond., 1927, 5: 241-3. Also Am. J. Phys. Ther., 1933, 10: 12-4.—Miller, C. R. Sedative hydrotherapy for psychotic patients. U. S. Veterans Bur. M. Bull., 1931, 7: 383-7.— Moor, F. B. Hydrotherapy for local injuries and infections. Arch. Phys. Ther., 1941, 22: 645-51.—O'Connor, W. F. The value and method of administering water in acute infections. J. Lancet, 1927, 47: 298-302.—Peck, R. E. Hydrotherapy among physiotherapists; a plea for its more general use. Arch. Phys. Ther., 1926, 7: 462-70.—Pincherle, M. Provvi- denze idrologiche e termaU per la tutela dell'infanzia. Riv. idrocUm., 1935, 46: 490-8.—Reuter. Wasser als Heilmittel und sein Gebrauch am Krankenbett. Fortsch. Med., 1935, 53: 41-3.—Rossbach. Hidroterapia; frfo y calor; agua frfa y caUente. Arch. ter. med. quir., Barcel., 1883-84, 2: 81; 102; 113; 132; 181; 1884-85, 3: 33; 53; 74.—Sachs, A. Hydro- therapie bei chirurgischen und dermatologischen Krank- heiten. Wien. med. Wschr., 1938, 88: 95-7.—Setz, M. Dauer- bader fiir Schwerverwundete. Zschr. ges. Krankenhauswes., 1933, 225.—Stewart, C. E. Hydrotherapy in chronic disorders. Arch. Phys. Ther., 1927, 8: 400-8.—Strasser, A. Hydrothera- pie. In Handb. Neur. (Bumke & Foerster) Berl., 1936, Bd 8, 581-604.—Vinaj, A. The hydrotherapy of disorders of the stomach and duodenum. Arch. M. Hydr., Lond., 1931, 9: 405-7.—Ward, J. L. The practical appUcation of hydro- therapy. Med. Progr., Louisv., 1926, 42: 151-4. Also Arch. Pediat., N. Y., 1928, 45: 555-61. ---- Institutes, congresses and societies. Debernardi, I. Osservazioni nei suo stab'li- mento idroterapico di Biella-Piazzo. 20p. 23^cm. Tor., 1870. Manayra, P. E. Relazione sull'andamento e risultato delle cure balneari e idropiniche dell'anno 1878. 52p. 21cm. Roma, 1879. Bornhofen, E. Die Diatkuche an der Hydrotherapeutischen Universitatsanstalt Berlin. Ther. Gegenwart, 1931, 72: 340- 3.—Chiray, M. Lecon d'ouverture, Chaire d'hydrologie thdrapeutique et de climatologie, Faculty de medecine de Paris. Presse mid., 1938, 46: 249-54.—Du Pasquier. Realisations thermales des caisses d'assurances sociales. Bull. Soc mid. Paris, 1938, 218-23.—LeSage, J. Faculte de medecine de Paris; le Professeur Maurice Chiray inaugure son enseignement k la Chaire d'hydrologie thdrapeutique. Union med. Canada, 1938, 67: 279-82.—Projets de creation d'une federation ther- male'et climatique internationale. Presse therm, clim., 1937, 78: 587.—Worsaae, E. [Twenty-fifth anniversary of the batfi9- and-massage clinic of the Bispebjerg Hospital] Hospitalstidende, 1938, 81: suppl., 235-8. ---- Manuals and periodicals. Abbott, G. K. Step technic of hydrotherapy; a manual for use with Physical therapy for nurses. 80p. 8? Wash. [19331 Brieger-Krebs. Grundnss der Hydrothera- pie. 2. Aufl. 149p. 8? Bonn, 1923. Casado, A. M., & Cervigon Diaz, A. Manual de practicas hidrol6gicas. 207p. 12? Madr., 1931. Coulter, J. S. Hydrotherapy, p.489-552. 22cm. Phila., 1938. Debernardi, I. Guida pratica alia idro- terapia. 74p. 16cm. Biella, 1881. Kellogg, J. H. Rational hydrotherapy. 2. ed. 1193p. 8? Phila., 1902-3. Le Quesne, R. M., & Granville, M. Hydro- therapy; a textbook for students. 142p. 8? Lond., 1933. , ,. Ray, M. B. Hydrotherapy and chmato- therapy. 312p. 8? Lond. [1936] HYDROTHERAPY 934 HYDROTHERAPY ---- Methods. Delmas, P. Des procedes mis en usage au debut d'un traitement hydrotherapique. 48p. 21cm. Bord., 1861. CiREGOR, W. *Wi(hsclformen in der Therapie. 25p. 8? Berl., 1932. Behrend, H. J. Modern technic in hydrotherapy. Arch. Phys. Ther., 19.16, 17: 436-41.—Cirla. P. Due nuovi metodi di cura idroterapica. Riv. idroclim., 1937. 48: 265-8.—Coon, G. Intorno all'idrosudopatia, awertimento. Gior. progr. pat., Venez., 1838, 8: 276.—Coulter, J. S. Practical hydrotherapy. Physiother. Rev., 1934, 14: No. 2, 10.—Dausset. IL. & Gerard. Les douches dites de Luxeuil et le service d'liydiotherapie medicale de l'Hotel-Dieu. Paris med., 1926, 59: 52-4 — Debidour, A., & Dubois, R. Reaction in hydrotherapy meas- ured by the oscillograph. Arch. M. Hydr., Lond., 1933, 11: 187-92.—Dilcher, G. Ueber die Schlenz-Kur. Hippokrates, Stuttg., 1938, 9: 244-6.—Dubois, R. L'hvdrotherapie It domicile. Hopital, 1927, 15: 420-3.—Eliet, J. E. Quelques precisions sur les maillots humides et froids. Clinique, Par., 1936, 31: 273.— Elsom, J. C, & Hawkins, F. M. Hydro- therapy treatment in a general hospital. Brit. J. Phys. M., 1932 7: 90.—Ernst, H., & Brizard, A. Technique hydro- thf'rapique k Divonne. Nutrition, Par., 1938, 8: 229-32.— Glaessner, K. Leber mineralfreie Wassertherapie. Schweiz. med Wschr., 1933, 63: 205-12.—Grabley, P. Hydrotherapie des praktischen Arztes. Med. Welt, 1929, 3: 90-2.—Harter, B. What do I need to give home water treatments? Health, Mount. View, 1941, 8: No. 11, 14.—Holmes, G. Hydro- therapy and spa treatment. Practitioner, Lond., 1938, 141: 133-44.—Lampert, H. Theorie und Praxis der Kiiltebehand- lung (Hydrotherapie) Hippokrates, Stuttg., 1935, 6: 841-8.— Lang, M. Ueber WasM-rstoffionenkonzentration der in der Dermatologic verwenilcten ollizinellen Umschlagwasser. Derm. Wschr., 1930, 91: 1-197.- Laqueur, A. Wasserbehandlung des praktischen Arztes. /.schr. nr/.tl. Fortbild., 1933, 30: 580-3 — Lowman, G. LeR. The Hydrogymnasium. Phi Chi Q., Menasha, 1936, 33: 61-6. Maltcn, H. Die Kaltwasscrbe- handlung. Med. Klin., Berl., 1938, 34: 1159-61. ------ Der Leibwiekel Ibid., 1430-2.—Perutz, A., & Lustig, B. Ueber die W a^erstoffionenkonzentration der in der Derma- tologie verwendeten offizinellen Umschlagwasser; iiber die Pufferkapazitat. Arch. exp. Path., Lpz., 1930, 149: 321-5.— Pope, C. The wet pack. Phys. Ther., 1926, 44: 37-18.— Remzi, R. [Easily applied methods in hydrotherapy] Askeri sihhiyc mecmuasi, 1934, 63: 1-12.—Sarason, 1). Ueber mineralfreie Wassertherapie; Einfiihrung in eine neue Ent- giftungs-Methode von Glaessner. Jahrkurs. iirztl. Fortbild., 1932, 23: 8, 43.—Schalle, A. Der Brustwickel, seine Technik, seine physiologische und theiapeutische Wirkung. Hippo- krates, Stuttg., 1936, 7: 1132-0— Singer, C. I. Effective European methods of hydrotherapy neglected in United States. Arch. Phys. Ther., 1936, 17: 631-5.—Tiegel, W. Die Schwenin- ger-Hauffeschen ansteigenden Teilwasserbader und ihre An- wendung in der tuglichen Praxis. Naturarztl. Rdsch., 1937, 9: 78-86.—Trois [F. E.l Dell'idrosudopatia. Gior. progr. pat., Venez., 1838, 8: 120-4.—Wolf, H. Hydrotherapy in the home. Internat. Clin., 1932, 42. ser., 3: 146. ---- Principles, and mode of action. Caille, J. *Influence de I'hydrotherapie sur le systeme neuro-vegetatif. 36p. 8? Par., 1934. _:--The same. 37p. 8° Par., 1934. Costa, D. J. C. da. *Algunas palavras sobre hydrotherapia racional. 89p. 8? Lisb., 1888. Abbott, G. K. The vasomotor effects of hydrotherapy itheii therapeutic use) Clin. M. & S., 1930, 37: 903-8 — Anders, J. M. Therapeutic aspects of hydrotherapy. Tr. Am. Ther Soc, 1925-26, 27: 169-73.—Bolton, F. E. Hvdro- PsyrhoM-s. Am. J. Psychol., 1898-9, 10: 169-227.—Botten- berg, H. Biologische Wasserheilbehandlung des praktischen Arztes; Warme und Kiilte als Heilreize. In his Biol. Ther., Munch., 1936, 119-48.—Burden, V. G. The surgical impor- tance of water. Ther. Gaz., Detr., 1926, 3. ser., 50: 480-4.— Carnot, P. L'eau en thdrapeutique externe. Nutrition, Par., 1938, 8: 133-46.—Debidour, A., & Dubois de Saujon, R., Action de I'hydrotherapie sur les reflexes neuro-v£g6tatifs et la pression arterielle (etude oscillographique) Bull. Soc. med. Paris. 1933, 191-212— Dieffenbach, W. H. The principles of hydrotherapy. Phys. Ther., 1929, 47: 381-7.—Dubois, R., & liogny. M. Etude compare des variations du pH urinaire et du ponb au cours de la cure hydrotherapique. Presse therm. chin., 1938, 79: 101-3.—Edward. H. Water as a curative! agent. Health Cult., N. Y.. 1941, 47: No. 9, 31—Fleury, L. j Hydrotherapie et hydrothorapeutistes; leurs pretentions. Presse med. beige, 1863-64, 16: 13; 21; 37.—Hauffe, G. Die Reizstiirke, als Mass der Einwirkung hydrotherapeutischer Anwendungen. Verh. Deut. Ges. inn. Med.. 1936. 48. Kongr., 251-6.------Nutzen und Gefahren der Hydrotherapie. Fortsch. Ther., 1930, 6: 146-50.—Hendriock, A. Experi- mentelle Untersuchungen tiler die preventive und Iokal- therapeutische Wirksamkeit feuchter Verbande, insbesondere der sogenannten spezifischen Verbande Besredka's. Zbl. Chir., 1927 54: 2325-33.—Herrmann, F. Ueber die Wirkung feuch- ter Umschlage. Derm. Zschr., 1927. 50: 277-94.—Hinsdale, G. Survey of the actual value of hydrotherapy. J. Am. M. Ass., 1927, 89: 502-0.—Kcrmogant, Y. Contribution k l'etude des .modifications du spectre sanguin observees au cours de I'hydrotherapie. Gaz. med. France, 1938, 4r>: Suppl., Therm., 14.-—Kmictowirz. F.. & Koskouski. W. Ueber einige Reak- tionen des Organismus nach Trinkkuren und Biidern. Balneo- loge, 1937, 4: 518-28.—Kopp. La quality effective de l'hydro- logie depend aussi de la qualite professionnelle du personnel soignant des etablis.sements d'hydrotherapie et des villes d'eaux. Commun. Congr. internat. physiother., 1930, 5. Congr., Sect. 3, No. 1, 45.—Lachman, S. Physiological principles and practical application of hydrotherapy. Med. Rec, N. Y., 1939, 150: 434-7.—Laqueur, A. Die Hedeutung des Hautreizes in dor Hydro- und Balneotherapie. Commun. Congr. internat. physiother., 1930, 5. Congr., Sect. 3, No. 2, 47-52 [Discussion] C. rend., 1931,90. --- Die Wirkungs- weise der Hydro-Thermotherapie auf den (lesauiiotgaidsmus, Med. Welt, 1930, 4: 1199-202.—Nylin, J. B. General principles of hydrotherapy. Arch. Phys. Ther., 1933, 14: 89 9 1. Pansini, G. L'importanza delle cure idro-tennaIi nella tutela dei lavoratori. Difesa sociale, 1936, 15: 867-76. —Pope, G. Hydro- therapy; its value and possibilities. Clin. M. k S., 1927, 34: 677-80.—Rondoni, P. La dottrina della infiammazhme nei riflessi idrologici. Riv. idroclim., 1934, 45: 289-303. Scholtz, H. G. Psychotechnische Untersuchungen iiber die Heein- flussung der Gesamtpersonlichkeit durch hydrotherapeutische Kurcn. Balneologe, 1939, 6: 474-82.—Schulhof, O. [Effect of hydrotherapy on various diseases] Gyo;:yasztit, 192y, 68: 180-9.—Spangenberg, H. I)., jr. Hot or cold applications; a review of the fundamental literature. J. Am. Dent. Ass., 1941, 28: 903-8.—Stewart, C. E. The principles of hydrotherapy. Med. Brief, 1926, 54: 618-23. Also Am. J. Phys. Ther., 1920 27, 3: 367-71.------ Water as a therapeutic agent. Arch. Phys. Ther., 1926, 7: 270-9.—Villaret, M., & Justin-Besancon, L. La pharmacodynamic hydrologique. Presse med., 1935, 43: 17-20.—Wybauw. Action physiologique de I'hydrotherapie. Rapp. Congr. internat. physiother., 1905, 1. Congr., No. 3, 1-16.—Zerlotto, I.. Studj pratici intorno il metodo curativo di Priesnitz detto idroterapia. Gior. progr. pat., Venez., 1846, ser. 2, 9: 161-95.—Zniniewicz, J. [On negative and positive reactions in the brain caused by hydrotherapy] Med. prakt., Poznari, 1936, 10: 356-61. ------ [Physiological principles of hydrotherapy] Nowiny lek., 1938, 50: 770-3. HYDROTHORAX. See under Thorax. HYDROXIDE. See Alkali; Lye. HYDROXYLAMINE. Gerendasi, G. *Das Verhalten des schild- driisenlosen Organismus bei der experimentellen Hydroxylaminvergiftung [Breslau] p.76-83. 8? BerL, 1929. Blom, J. Zum Nachweis von Hydroxylamin. Biochem. Zschr., 1928, 194:385-91.------Bildung von Hydroxylamin bei der Reduktion von Nitraten durch Mikroorganismen; ein Beitrag zur Kenntnis der Bildung von Aminosauren durch Mikroorganismen. Ibid., 392-409.—Gros, R. Recherche, elimination et dosage de l'ammoniaque dans le chlorhydratc d'hydroxylamine. J. pharm. chim., Par., 1922, 7. ser., 26: 149-52.—James, T. H. Effect of catalysis upon the oxidation products of hydroxvlamine. J. Am. Chem. Soc, 1942, 64: 731-4.—Lemoigne, M„ & Desveaux, R. Recherches sur lo role biochimique de l'hvdroxylamine; formation de I'hydro- xylamine. Bull. Soc. chim. biol., Par., 1936, 18: 604-14. ------& Monguillon, P. Recherches sur le r61e biologique dc I'hydroxylamine; contribution k l'etude de la caraotfirisation de I'liydroxylamine. Ibid., 841-67. ------ Recherches sur le r61e biologique de I'hydroxylamine; presence de I'hydroxylamine dans les feuilles des vegetaux superieurs. Ibid., 868-76.----— Recherches sur le role biologique de I'hydroxylamine; produc- tion de I'hydroxylamine par le Sterigmatocystis nigra aux d6pens de l'azote nitrique et de l'azote ammoniacal. Ibid., 1291; 1297. ------ Nouveaux rfisultats sur la presence do composes volatils de I'hydroxylamine dans les feuilles fraichea les vegetaux superieurs. Ibid., 1937, 19: 617-4.------ Recherches sur le role biologique de I'hydroxylamine; utilisation le I'hydroxylamine par les v6g6taux sup6rieurs. Ibid., 1938, 20: 441-8— Lindsey, G. A., & Rhine*. C. M. The production of hydroxylamine by the reduction of nitrates and nitrites b\ various pure cultures of bacteria. .1. Bact., Bait., 1932, 24: 189-92.—Marschalk, C. Action de I'hydroxylamine sur la quinizarine et so.s derives en milieu alcalin. Bull. Soc chim. France, 1937, 5. ser., 4: m6m., 629-36.—Palfray, I... & Tallard. S. Sur l'influence de l'acidite libre sur le dosage des aldehydes et c6tones par le chlorhydrate d'hydroxylamine. C. rend. Acad. sc, 1931, 199: 296-8.—Wislicki, L., & Gerendasi, G. Das Verhalten des schilddriisenlosen Organismus gegenuber der experimentellen Hydroxylaminvergiftung. Zschr. ges. exp. Med., 1929, 67: 76-83. HYDROXYL COMPOUNDS 935 HYGIENE HYDROXYL compounds. See also Acids, polybasic. Artom, C, Gagliani, M., & Ventura, E. Contributo alio studio del metabolismo degli idrossiacidi superiori. Boll. Soc ital. biol. sper., 1937, 274. Also Riv. pat. sper., 1937 19- 84- 108.—Bartlett, P. D., Kuna, M., & Levene, P. A. The con- figurational relationship of a-hydroxy-n-valeric and a-hydro- xyisovaleric acids. J. Biol. Chem.. 1937, 118: 503; 513. 'Also repr.—Browning, C. IL, Cohen, J. B. [et al.] The therapeutic action of some bismuthyl derivatives of organic hydroxy-acids Proc R. Soc., Lond., 1927, ser. B, 102: 1-9.—Dakin, H. B\ The synthesis of inactive para- and anti-hvdroxyaspartic acids (aminomalic acids) J. Biol. Chem., 1921, 48: 273-91. The resolution of hydroxyaspartic acids into optically active forms. Ibid., 1922, 50: 403-11.—Fox, J. J., & Martin, A. E. Investigations of infra-red spectra; absorption of some hydroxy compounds in the region of 3^. Proc. R. Soc, Lond., 1937 ser. A, 162: 419-41.—Harington, C. R., Randall, S. S., & Richardson, G. M. Synthesis of i-B-hydroxyglutamic acid, with a note on the dissociation constants. Biochem J Lond 1931, 25: 1917-30.—Jungers, J. C, & Bonhoeffer, K. F.' Ueber die Austauschgeschwindigkeit des Hvdroxylwasserstoffs in -wiisserigen Losungen. Zschr. phys. Chem., Abt. A, 1936 177: 460-4.—Klemenc, A. Die elektrolytisehen Vorgange an der Anode als Wirkungen des Hydroxvls. Ibid., 1939-40 185- 1-36.—Levene, P. A., & Taylor, F. A. The synthesis of a- hydroxyisopentacosanic acid and its bearing on the structure of cerebronic acid. J. Biol. Chem., 1922, 52: 227-40.—Peterson, V. L., & West, E. S. The volumetric estimation of hydroxy! groups in sugars and other organic compounds. Ibid., 1927 74: 379-83.—Stekol, J. A. The metaboUsm of 1- and dl-a- hydroxy-0-benzylthiopropionic and dl-a-hvdroxy-y-benzyl- thiobutyric acids in the rat. Ibid., 1941, 140: 827-31. Also repr.—Weil-Malherbe, H. The oxidation of 1(—)a-hydroxy- glutaric acid in animal tissues. Biochem. J., Lond., 1937, 31: 2080-94. ------ a-Hydroxyacetoacetic acid; preparation, properties, and estimation; metabolism in animal tissues Ibid., 1938, 32: 1033-53. HYDROXYLYSINE. Martin, A. J. P., & Synge, R. L. M. Hvdroxylysine. Bio- chem. J., Lond., 1941, 35: 307-12.—Van Slyke, D. D., Hiller, A., & MacFadyen, D. A. The determination of hydroxvlysine in proteins. J. Biol. Chem., 1941, 141: 681-705. HYDROZOA. See Coelenterata. HYER, Godfrey, S. *TJn cas de tumeur maligne de l'ovaire avec metastases osseuses. 23p. 23cm. Lausanne, C. Risold, 1940. HYGEIA. Chic, v.l, 1923- See also Taylor, A. C. The responsibility of the Woman's Auxiliary toward Hygeia. Wisconsin M. J., 1941, 40: 1258-63. HYGIANDER [pseud.] Regeln von dem Urin unbetriiglich zu urtheilen; unveranderter Abdruck der Ausgabe von 1744; Vorwort von Alfred Pfleiderer. [15] 52 [6]p. illust. 16? Lpz., Kriiger & Co., 1937. HYGIEA. Stockh., v.1-100, 1839-1938. Continued in Nordisk medicin. HYGIENE. See also Health; Hygiene, public. For special aspects of hygiene see such headings as Industrial hygiene; Mental hygiene; School hygiene, etc. Frankman, W. The neglected part of the human body [l]p. 31cm. [n. p., 1936] Neisser, M. Hygiene als biologische Wissen- schaft; Rede bei der Uebernahme des Rektorates gehalten in der Aula der Universitat Frankfurt a. M., am 23. Oktober, 1921. 19p. 8? Frankf. a. M. [1921] Vannetti, L. Nozioni fisico-naturali appli- cabili alia igiene ed alia economia domestica. 96p. 18^cm. Fir., 1863. Alfabcto sanitario. Salud & san., Bogota, 1939-40, 8: No. 95/100, 3-19.—Ar e sol. Impr. med., Rio, 1941, 17: No. 334, 125.—Burnham, W. H. The fundamental principle of hygiene. Pedag. Semin., Worcester, 1918, 25: 329-68 — Daniel, A. Hygiene integrale et culture humaine. Avenir med., Par., 1939, 36: 10-2.—Dublin, L. I., Brown, B. [et al.] American Museum of Hygiene. Am. J. Pub. Health, 1942,' 32: No. 3, Sunnl 52 —Ehrismann, O. Der physiologische Gedanke in derHygiene. Deut. med. Wschr., 1939, 65: 17-9.-G[rimaud] de C[raux] G. Hygiene physiologique. Gaz. san., Par., 1835, cl~A w~~u£W,Tn& L S- The ldeaIs of Battle Creek College. Good Health, 1936, 71: 44.-KisskaIt, K. Pseudohygiene Munch, med. Wschr., 1939, 86: 877-80.-LeSage, J. S. P?opoS .ygieniques; le physique et le moral. Union med. Canada mn*kZ°' US8'_'N,nJ M"A La h»SMme; conceptos filosoficos modernos. Rev. med. cubana, 1939, 50: 130-6;—Ottolenghi U. Igiene e rendimento. Riforma med., 1936 52: 207-10—' Sigenst, H. E. The philosophy of hygiene. Bull. Johns Hopkins Hosp., 1933 53: Suppl., 323-31. Also repr.-SzuIc, G. Ltiygiene and esthetics] Lek. wojsk., 1929, 14: 451-8. ---- Bibliography. American Red Cross. A bibliography of supplementary material for classes in home hygiene and care of the sick. 23p. 4? [Wash 1 1936. i » -J Boorde, A. The wisdom of Andrew Boorde; ed. by H. Edmund Poole. 63p. 8? Leicester, 1936. Chayer, M. E. Bibliography in health educa- tion for schools and colleges. lOOp. 8° [N Yl 1936. ' David, R. *L'hygiene religieuse dans les livres sacres. 43p. 8? Par., 1926. Elyot, T. The castel of helthe (1541) 3 1. [12]p. 94 numb. 1. 19^cm. N. Y., 1937. Fishbein, M. Health books old and new. 31p. 16? Chic, 1936. Literatura medica se exhibe ahora en la Casa de Sanidad. Bol. san. Guatemala, 1938, 9: 514.—[Review of articles on hygiene submitted to the journal] Gig. & zdorov., 1941 6: No. 6, 47-52. ---- Essays. Echkenazy, B. *Vanves; l'hygiene en action. 322p. 8? Par., 1929. Steele, L. In the light of the health schools. 298p. 8? Rapid City, S. D. [1932] Germano da Silva Correia, A. C. Os novos horizontes em higiene. Arq. Esc. med. cir. Nova Goa, 1938, sir. A, No. 12, 37-56.—Ide, M. Les manies de l'hygiene. Rev. med. Louvain 1924, 118-21.—Kollath, W. Neue Aufgaben und Losungen der Hygiene. Hippokrates, Stuttg., 1938, 9: 831-6.—Razetti, L. Aforismos de higiene y de moral. Congr. med. centroamer., 1936, 4. Congr., 189.—Stegman, H. M. The beechers and the biologic life. Good Health, 1936, 71: 40.—Storey, T. A. Alias hygiene. Pedag. Semin., Worcester, 1920, 27: 67-70. ---- Exhibitions. See also Health education. Hiscock, I. V. Health field day, Greenwich, Conn., September 15, 1937; address. 5 1. 27cm. N. Haven, 1937. Hyspa; erste Schweizerische Ausstellung fiir Gesundheitspflege und Sport, Bern, 24. Juli bis 20. September 1931. Schluss-Bericht. 504p. 8? Bern, 1932. As the press saw our health show. Bull. Los Angeles Co. M. Ass., 1941, 71: 170-7.—Bateman, A. D. El dfa de la salud. Rev. hig., Bogota, 1940, 21: No. 11, 3-6.—Cavallo, C. J. La conmemoraci6n nacional del Dfa Panamericano de la Salud. Reforma med., Lima, 1940, 26: 769-79.—Conmemoracion del dfa panamericano de la salud. Bol. Of. san. panamer., 1941. 20: 25-31.—Cumming, H. S. Dia Panamericano de la salud. Bol. san., B. Air., 1940, 4: 599. ------Araoz Alfaro, G. [et al.] Dia Panamericano de la salud. Bol. Of. san. panamer., 1940. 19: 1167-218.—L. Gang durch die Hyspa. Schweiz. med. Wschr., 1931, 61: Beil. No. 30, 3-10.—Primer dia panamericano de la salud. Bol. Of. san. panamer., 1941, 20: 73-5. ---- History. Botjrrotjet, A. *Les origines ethnographiques de l'hygiene. 56p. 8? Par., 1934. Decker, A. Kenntnis und Pflege des Korpers bei Clemens von Alexandria. 74p. 8? Innsbr., 1936. Girard, R. *Contribution a l'etude de 1'histoire de l'hygiene en France. 122p. 8? Pur., 1936. Coquet, F. de. L'hygiene autrefois et aujourd'hui. J. med. Bordeaux, 1926, 56: 576-80.—Dezeo. P. O. Doctrinas hi- gienicas del siglo XIX. Sem. med., B. Air., 1940, 47: pt 2, 754-60.—Du Bois, C. Hygiene blanche et hygiene noire. Rev. med. Suisse rom., 1941, 61: 127.—Fontenelle. J. P. A evolucao da hygiene; ensaio historico. Fol. med., Rio, 1930, HYGIENE 936 HYGIENE 11: 292-5.—Fontenelle, O. A higiene atraves dos tempos. Ibid., 1939, 20: 465— Gangitano. L. I Vscrizione di alcuni prcparati hsm-i conservari nd Museo dell'Accademia di Storia dell'Arte Sanitaria. Rass. clin. ter., 1937, 36: No. 6, Suppl., 304-19. — Gauducheau, A. I.'etat naturel; origines de l'hy- giene. Rev. hvg.. Par., 1927, 49: 321-35.—Gossen, H. Hy- giene in ancient Rome. Ciba Symposia, 1939-40, 1: No. 2, 29- 32.--Ichok. G. L'hygiene il y a un siocle et demi. Hev. hyg.. Par., 1939. 61: 297 302.—Igiene di Roma antica. Mi- nerva med.. Idi., 1940, 31: pt 2, varia, 82-4 (microfilm) — Knorr, M. Rundscliau: Altes und Neues uber die hygienische Ru-tung und ihre Grundlagen. Jahrkurs. arztl. Fortbild., 1930, 27: II. 10, 1-19.—Lamego, L. Higiene medieval. Vida med.. Kin, 1941, 9: No. 4, 4-9.—Moll, A. A. La sanidad a irav-V de los siglos. Bol. Of. san. panamer., 1930, 9: 364-87.— Montgomery, D. W. Banquets of contribution. Ann. M. Hist , 19-K). 3. ser., 2: 140-3.—Sangiorgi, G. Vittoria dell'i- giene nella vittoria imperiale. Pensiero med., 1936, 25: 235- 9.—SchaefTer, A. M. Hvgiene in Colonial times. Nation's Health, Chic, 1926, 8: 741; 798.—Schultze, E. Reinlichkeit, Bad und Wasche bei den mykenischen Griechen. Miinch. med. Wschr., 1937, 84: 743-5.—Varron, A. G. Personal hvgiene during the Middle Ages. Ciba Symposia, 1939—40, I: 215-23.—Wagner, G. F. Hygiene. In Marksteine Entw. Med. (Hoist, W.) Danzig, 1939, 57-62. ---- Instruction. Soe also Health education. Auroy, M. *L'hygiene a la Cite Universitaire. 43p. 8? Par., 1936. Blount, R. E. Teachers' manual for the science of everyday health. 88p. 8? Bost., N. Y. [1935] Chappelear, C. S. *Health subject matter in natural sciences [Columbia Univ.] 107p. 8? N. Y., 1929. Chayer, M. E. School nursing; a contribution to health education. 2. ed. 329p. 8? N. Y., 1937. Dobbs, A. A. Teaching wholesome living in the elementary school. 304p. 2312cm. N. Y. [1939] Flager, A. M. The correspondence course of the Macfadden Institute of Physical Culture, Inc. 417 1. 4? Wilmington, Del., 1933. Greog, F. M., & Rowell, H. G. Health studies, home and community; teacher's manual. 64p. 8? Yonkers [1932] Grout, R. E. Handbook of health education; a guide for teachers in rural schools. 298p. 8" Garden City, X. Y. [1936] Hill, F. E. Educating for health. 224p. 19^cm. N. Y., 1939. Hussey, M. M. Teaching for health. 312p. 8? N. Y., 1938. Patty, W. W. Teaching health and safety in elementary grades. 371p. 21cm. N. Y., 1940. Rhoton, P. Health misconceptions of pros- pective teachers. 80p. 8? State College, Pa., 1932. Riddle, O. Better health through expanded science teaching. [3]p. 2512cm. [n. p., 1940] Rogers, J. F. Instruction in hygiene in institutions of higher education. 47p. X? Wash., 1936. ---- Student interests and needs in hygiene. 21 p. 8? Wash., 1937. Ruef, D. X. *Health education in senior high schools; a study of the qualifications, status, affiliations, and functions of persons responsible for health education in senior high schools, with special reference to Xew Jersev [Columbia Univ.] 106p. 8? X. Y, 1934. Spencer, M. E. *Health education for teachers; a critical study of the pre-service preparation of classroom teachers for the school health program. 118p. 8? X. Y., 1933. Storey. T. A. The status of hygiene programs in institutions of higher education in the United States. 125p. 8? Stanford Univ., 1927. U. S. National Education Association. Joint committee on health problems in education. Health education. [2. rev.] 36Np. 23'.cm. Wash. [1941] Weber, L. M. Functional health teaching syllabus. 165p. 24cm. Bost. [1941] Wootten, K. W. Health workbook. 3. ed. 2l4p. 27cm. N. Y., 1939. Allen, H. S. Development of public health education Connecticut Health Bull., 1938, 52: 214-S. Allen. K. I,. How shall we teach health? J. School Health, 1939, 9: 99 102.—Bowen, M. E. Health teaching in a sccondarv school Pub. Health Nurs., 1937, 29: 292-8.—Brown, It. K. The importance of teaching hygiene in elemental v and secondary schools. J. State M., bond., 1934, 42: 197-207.--Hurden, N. j. Aspects of college hygiene. J. Health Phys. Educ, 1935. 6: 12-58.- -Cassidy, R. The concept of integration as il functions in health education. Ibid., 1941, 12: 306-8.- Chittirk, l{. The teaching of health in normal schools. Canad. I'uh. Health J., 1929, 20: 186-92.—Coops, H. L.. k Chenoweth, L. B. Unit method of teaching hygiene in college. L Lancet, 1937, 57: 306-9.—Counet, T. Le cours d'hygidne dans les 6co!es. Mouve- ment hyg., Brux., 1911, 27: 434-40.—< rap.scr, A. L. Health education teachers' training program. Nation's Health, Chic 1927, 9: No. 5, 29.—Daranyi, J. Die Ausbildung in der Hy- giene bei den Kulturvolkern. Orvoskepzes, 1935, 25: mar. kulonf. Educ. med., 175-324.—Davey, M. E. A tentative health vocabulary for the junior high school. Abstr. Theses Univ. Pittsburgh, 1932, 8: 318.—DeWeese, A. O. Adjusting college informational hygiene to various grade levels. .) Lancet, 193-1, 54: 386-8.—Dix, K. VV. Hygieneunterrichl als Basis der I'eisonlichkeitsgestaltung der Madchen in Berufs- schuleu. Gesundh. & Erzieh., 1936, 49: 236-46.—Forsythe, W. E. Things to forget in health teaching. J. Health, Ann Arbor, 1934, 5: 18-67.—Fuller, J. D. Public health training for teachers. Week. Bull. California Dep. Pub. Health, 1941- 42, 20: 121.—Grout, R. E. Rural supervision of health educa- tion. J. Health, 1937, 8: 78; 120.—Individual health and hy- giene; a list of free and inexpensive teaching materials. Am J. Nurs., 1942, 42: 83-5.—Jameson, W. W. The teaching of hygiene. Brit. M. J., 1928, 2: 733-7.—Kanevsky, A. [Method in sanitary educational courses] Profil. med., Kharkov, 1927 6: No. 5, 117-21.—Kent, F. S., & Prentice, H. A. Teaching hygiene visually. Res. Q. Am. Ass. Health, 1940, 11: No. 2, 90-9.—l.egere, M. B., & Schryer, M. D. A problem in health teaching. Canad. Nurse, 1941, 37: 121.—l.indeburgh, M. Teaching of health in high schools. Canad. Pub. Health, j., 1929, 20: 294-8.—Lorentz, F. Der Gesundheitsunterricht in der modernen Schule. Fortsch. Gesundhfurs., 1933, 7: 18-21.— McNeil, II. D. Democratic tool. Health Off. News Digest 1941, 6: \... 11, 3— Mealey, E. M. Health education of teachers; some trends in their preparation. Child Health Bull., 1933, 9: 167-72.—Micchi, R. Come si insegna l'igiene nelle scuole del Nord America. Igiene mod., 1926, 19: 1; 33.— Milman, I. I. [Certain actual questions of sanitary service education in schools] Gig. san., Moskva, 1939, 4: No. 11, 39-45.—Montgomery, R. B. College hygiene courses. Res. Q. Am. Ass. Health, 1941, 12: 556-65.— Neagle, M. A health teaching project in a 1-room school; the uses and protection of our water supply. Week. Bull. California Dep. Pub. Health, 1938-39, 17: 141; 146.—OberteufTer, D. Preliminary study of criteria for the selection and organization of learning experience in health instruction. Res. Q. Am. Phys. Educ. Ass., 1935, 6: 63-5.—Patty, W. W. The teaching of health education in elementary schools. J. Health Phys. Educ, 1934, 5: 3-60.— I'roca, G. [Instructions and application of hygiene] Romania med., 1931, 12: 61-3.—Reynolds, C. V. Health and its rela- tion to education. Health Bull., Raleigh, 1938, 53: No. 9, 3-7.—Rice, T. B. What shall we teach in hygiene? Month. Bull. Indiana Div. Pub. Health, 1936, 39: 171; 1937, 40: 3; 23.—Roberts, R. H. Education in health for the teacher-in- service. J. Health Phys. Educ, 1939, 10: 131-3.—Rosenhaupt, H. Die behrerausbildung auf dem Gebiete der Gesundheits- pflege. Arch, sozial. Hyg., 1925-26, n. F., 1: 310-3.—Rostan. Cours elementaire d'hyghme. Observ. sc. med., 1823, 5: 124.— Rowell, H. G. Laboratory aspects of college courses in hygiene. Am. J. Pub. Health, 1927, 17: 215-20.—Sokolov, I. S. [The work of lecturers on hygiene] Gig. & zdorov., 1941, 6: No. 2, 40-4.—Sovetov, S. [Sanitary pedagogics, as science and as a subject of leaching] Profil. med., Kharkov, 1927, 6: 84-91.— Stafford, F. S. Recommendations for standardization of teacher training institutions that train teachers of health; a summary of a study by the Indiana advisory council. Month. Bull. Bd Health Indiana, 1941, 44: 31; 41-3.—Story, T. A. Qualifications for teaching health. J. Am. M. Ass., 1938, 111: 724.—Storey, T. A. The hygiene program at Stanford Uni- versity. West. Hosp. Rev., 1931, 17: 26-33. Suggett, T. In-service training of teachers. J. School Health, 19-10, 10: 167.—Summer courses in public health. Pub. Health News, Trenton, 1934, 18: 127; 1939, 23: 67; 1940, 24: 67.—Sundwall, J. The teaching of college hvgiene. Am. J. Pub. Health, 1927, 17: 48-57. ------ Connolly, M. P. fel al] Preliminary report of the sub-committee on the educational qualifications of adult health educators. Ibid., 1937, 27: 717-21.—Sutton, H. The teaching of hygiene in schools. Med. .[. Australia, 1927, 1: 668 71. -Tire, F. The neighboihood post-graduate school. HYGIENE 937 HYGIENE Illinois Health Mess., 1941, 13: 42-4.—Vonderlehr, R. A. Fourth National Social Hygiene Day, February 1, 1940. Health Off., Wash., 1939, 4: 313.—Wachter, R. Ein Jahr Sport-, Hygiene- und Tuberkuloseunterricht bei Kindern Tuberkulose, Munch., 1924, 4: 79.—Weber, R. Hygiene- unterricht an Fortbildungsschulen. Aerztl. Mitt. Baden, 1928, 82: 8; 22.—Zwanck, A. Orientaciones modernas en la ensefianza de la higiene. Sem. mid., B. Air., 1931, 38: pt 2 1893-9. ---- Manuals. Adam, C, & Kayser, C. Hygienische Tat- sachen die man sonst nur muhs-am findet. 119p 8? Jena, 1931. Adam, L. C, & Boome, E. J., eds. Notter & Firth's Hygiene. 10. ed. [New impression] 518p 22^cm. Lond. [1941] Anderson, T. A. The practical monitor for the preservation of health and the prevention of diseases. 253p. 19>'2cm. Roma, 1907. Pizon, A. Lecons d'hygiene. Nouv. ed. 310p. 19cm. Par., 1938. Price, G. M. Hygiene and sanitation; a text- book for nurses. 5. ed. 286p. 8? Phila., 1927 Also 6. ed. 295p. 1935. Rathbone, J. L., Bacon, F. L., & Keene, C. H. Foundations of health. 413p. 8? Bost., 1932. Robertson, W. An introduction to hygiene. 207p. 8? Edinb., 1931. Schurmann, W. Repetitorium der Hygiene und Bakteriologie in Frage und Antwort. 5. Aufl. 234p. 8? Berl., 1931. Scott, K. F. A college course in hygiene. 202p. 26cm. N. Y., 1939. Smiley, D. F., & Gould, A. G. A college text- book of hygiene. 2. ed. 383p. 8? N. Y., 1934. Also 3. ed. 539p. 1940. Smiley, D. F., Gould, A. G., & Melby, E. The principles and practice of hygiene. 415p. 8? N. Y., 1930. Smith, R. C. F. Hygiene for schools. 299p. 20cm. Lond., 1938. Storey, T. A. A general outline and syllabus on hygiene. 114p. 8? Wash., 1920. ---- General hygiene. Book 1: Constructive hygiene, the determining and contributory causes of health. 4. ed. 236p. 8° Stanford Univ., 1930. ---- Defensive hygiene. Book 2: The agents that injure health, defenses against pathogens, the carriers of pathogens, the contributory causes of poor health. 236p. 8? Stanford, 1928. ----Principles of hygiene. 475p. 8? Stan- ford Univ., 1930. Tonina, T. A. Elementos de higiene. 2. ed. 549p. 23cm. B. Aires, 1938. Virginia State Department of Health. Health manual for schools. 40p. 23cm. Rich- mond, 1941. Webb, H. A. Keystone general science units. Unit 4: Health. 57p. 8? Meadville. Penna. [1932] HYGIENE 938 HYGIENE Weger, G. S. Health lessons. 8? [Redlands, Calif.] 1931. Weinzirl, J. General hygiene and preventive medicine. 424p. 8? Phila., 1937. Whitman, R. C. Hygiene, a college textbook for non-medical students. 8? N. Y., 1930. Williams, J. F. Hygiene and sanitation; the essentials of modern health care. 2. ed. 362p. K° Phila., 1930. Wootten, K. W. A health workbook for college freshmen. 205p. 8? Milledgeville, Ga., 1933. Worcester, A. Hygiene for freshmen. 151p. 8? Springfield [1934] Health manual for teachers. Virginia Health Bull., 1934, 26: 1-30. ---- mental. See Mental hygiene. ---- military. See Military hygiene. ---- municipal. See Towns, hygiene. ---- Officers. See Health officer. ---- Periodicals. Capital's health. Wash., v.l, 1941- Everybody's health. St. Paul, v. 19, 1934- Gazette de sante; a l'usage des gens du monde, des cures et des bienfaiteurs des pauvres. Par., v.1-3, 1833-35. Gesi-xdheitsdienst; Vierteljahresschrift fiir Gesundheitsforderung. Berl., 1940- Gesundheitslehrer. VolkstumliChe Zeit- schrift fur Gesundheitspflege. Ausgabe B. Berl., v.36, 1933- Hartford health bulletin; published by the Hartford Board of Health. Hartford, v.6, No. 10 (1941)- Health. Concord, N. H., 1924- Health and happiness. S. Antonio, v.l, 1934- Health, formerly Michigan Out-of-Doors. Lansing, v.21, 1934- Healtii. Mountain View, Calif., No. 7, No. 11, 1940- Health. Toronto, v.l, 1933. Illinois. State Department of Public Health. Radio talks [mimeo] Springfield, No. 194, 1933- Journal (The) of health and physical education. Ann Arb., v.l, 1930- Life and Health; the national health journal. Takoma Park, D. C, v.50, 1925- Mouvement (Le) hygienique. Brux., v.24- 30, 1908-14. National health review. Ottawa, v.l, 1933- National negro health news. Wash., v.l, 1933- Nevada Board of Health. Bulletin, ('ar- son City, 1934- New Hampshire health news. Concord, \. H. v.19 (1941)- Omaha, Neb. Bureau of Health. Health bulletin. Omaha, Neb., v.4 (1941)- Peoria health news. Peoria ,1940- United States. Public Health Service. Keep well series. Wash., Nos 1-4, 1919; No. 6, 1919; Nos 8-12, 1919-20. Voz (La) de la Sanidad de la XV Division [Spain] No. 15, 1937- Washincton Sanitarium health exponent. Wash., v.l, Nos 14-9; v.2, Nos 1-3. ---- personal. See also Health. Anthony, R. L. F., Heuyer [et al.] Anthro- pologie; hygiene individuelle; education physique. 2. ed. 464p. 8? Par., 1929. Arte (L') del viver bene; almanacco mensile redatto da una Societa du uomini positivi; anno primo. 96p.; 127p.; 96p. 15cm. Milano, IS69. Breccia, G. Resurrezione. 3. ed. lfifip. S? Roma, 1936. Cutter, C. A treatise on anatomy, physi- ology, and hygiene. Rev. ed. 466p. 12? N. Y., 1858. Fairchild, M. A. How to be well; or, Com- mon-sense medical hygiene. 180p. 8? N. Y., 1S79. Haggard, H. W. What you should know about health and disease. 538p. 8? N. Y., 1928. Hallock, G. T. A tale of soap and water. 91p. 18>^cm. N. Y. [1937] Hatch, L. M. To the coast rangers on cleanliness. 12p. 8? [Charleston, 180?] HEnESTREiT, H., Hoffmann, W., & Teitge, H. Schutz und Erhaltung der Arbeitskraft. 338p. 2iy2cm. Berl., 1939. Heiser, V. G. Toughen up, America! 228p. 2lcm. N. Y. [1941] Henderson, G. W. Tabulated manual of anatomy, physiology and hygiene, together with the effects of alcohol upon the system [&c] 151p. 8? Vaughnsville, O., 1889. Hickman, C. P. Physiological hygiene. 493p. 8? N. Y., 1937. Hotze, C. L. Lessons in anatomy, physiology, arid hygiene. 384p. 12? S. Louis, 1897. Hutchison, J. C. Treatise on physiology and hvgiene for educational institutions and general readers; 1884, 1888, 1895 and 1898 ed. 12? N. Y., 1884-1898. ----Lessons in physiology and hygiene, in 2 books; second book for advanced grades. 327p. 12? N. Y., 1895. Also other ed. 371p. 1902. Krueger, W. W" The fundamentals of personal hygiene, including their practical ap- plication to healthful living. 291p. 8? Phila., 1932. Lane, W. A. New health for everyman. 202p. 8? Lond. [1932] Laurent, H. Manual de higiene popular. 141p. 12° Guayaquil, 1917. McKeever, W. IL, & Shannon, T. W. [et al.l Science of living. 1240p. 8? Marietta, Ohio, 1927. Mead, H. T. *A survey and evaluation of personal hygiene as taught in the accredited colleges and universities of the New England States. 184p. 8? 1935. New York, N. Y. Cleanliness Institute. Cleanliness teaching for boys and girls of grades 6, 7, 8, and 9. 18p. 18^cm. N. Y. [1936] Nishi, K. Nishi system of health engineering. 244p. 8? Tokyo, 1936. O'Donovan-Rossa, M. Let's help the doctor. 141p. 8? N. Y. [1937] Quesada, O. M. La salud y el cuerpo'humano. 160p. 25^cm. Lima, 1914. HYGIENE 939 HYGIENE, PUBLIC Reilly, H. J. The secret of better health. 221p. 23cm. N. Y., 1941. Rice, T. B. Living. 464p. 23^cm. Chic. [1940] Schanz, K., Berg, R. [et al.] Neuzeitliche (lesundheitspflege; ein Lehrbuch fiir Gesunde und Kranke. 980p. 8? Zur. [1937] Soper, H. W. Health, mental, moral and physical. 109p. 19y2cm. Bost. [1941] Steele, J. D. Abridgment of the hygienic physiology, with special reference to alcoholic drinks and narcotics. 192p. 8? N. Y. [18841 Stowell, C. H. Healthy body. 3. ed. 222p. 12? N. Y., 1891. ---- Essentials of health; a text-book on anatomy, physiology, hygiene, alcohol, and narcotics. 376p. 12? N. Y., 1896. Sutherland-Gower, R. Cleanliness versus corruption. 56p. 12? Lond., 1910. Turner, C. E., & McHose, E. Effective living. 432p. 22^cm. S. Louis, 1941. _ White, G. S. Intestinal normalizing and pelvic culture for men. 2. ed. 112p. 8? Los Ang. [1936] Williams, J. F. Healthful living, based on the essentials of physiology. 3. rev. ed. 600p. 22cm. N. Y. [1941] ---- Personal hygiene applied. 7. ed. 529p. 20y~cxxx. Phila., 1941. Wing ate, C. F. The sanitary question-box. 42p. 16° N. Y., 1907. Brown, W. H. Hygiene of cleanliness. In Pract. Libr. M. & S. (Appleton) N. Y., 1937, 12: 129-37.—Cleanliness. Hvgeia, Chic, 1942, 20: 331.—Hiscock, I. V. Adult hygiene. In Pract. Libr. M. & S. (Appleton) N. Y., 1937, 12: 500-5 — Lombard, H. L. Adult hygiene. Commonhealth, Bost., 1935, 22: 251-5.—Merrill, E. B. Personal hygiene and first aid preparedness. Nat. Negro Health News, 1941, 9: No. 2, 4.— O wad some power ... Occupations, 1941-42, 20: 445. ----racial. See Eugenics. ---- sexual. See Sex life, Hygiene. ---- Societies. France. Society francaise d'hygiene. Constitution de la Societe; statuts. 8p. 21 ^cm. Par., 1877. A „ Foundation of the German society of hygiene. J. Am M. Ass 1936, 107: 2063.—Reiter. H. Die Deutsche Gesellschaft fur Hygiene. Reichsgesundhbl., 1936, 11: 907-11—Ruge.H. Tagung der Deutschen Gesellschaft fur Hygiene 3. bis 6. Oktober 1938 in Berlin. Med. Welt, 1938, 12: 1784; 1821. HYGIENE (L') mentale. Par., v.20, No. 5— v.34, No. 6, 1925-39. . Formerly Informateur (L') des alienistes et des neurologistes. HYGIENE, public. See also Epidemiology; Group, Health; Health board; Health law; Health officer; Health organization; Health, public; Preventive medi- cine; Sanitation, etc. Lane, W. A. Blazing the health trail. 148p. 8? Lond., 1929. Pan American Sanitary Bureau. Publica- tion No 156: Pan American public health quiz, with answers. 15 1. 27cm. Wash., 1940. Arbona, G. Cleanliness and sanitation; a duty and a weapon. Puerto Rico Health Bull., 1942, 6: 83-6.—Arnold, L. The biological aspects of public health and Preventive medicine. Phi Chi Q., Menasha, 1934, 31: No. 3, 358-60.—Gabotte, I. Beau-dit-1'Ange a des principes; farce medico-policiere. Strasbourg med., 1939, 99: Suppl., 33-6.-Kle.n, W & Sutter- lin, T. Allgemeine Hygiene. In Amtsarzt, Jena, 193b,^!lo- 90 —Marx, G. W. Self defense. Arizona Pub. Health News, 1941 34: No. 4, 2-4.—Valienfe, J. F. Importancia de la higiene moderna en el desarrollo de las naciones. Bol. Of. san. panamer., 1942, 21: 219-22. ---- Bibliography. Geiger, J. C, ed. The 1940 year book of public health. 560p. 18^cm. Chic. [1940] ---- The 1941 year book of public health. 544p. 18^cm. Chic. [1941] Patterson, R. S. A selected public health bibliography with annotations. Am. J. Pub. Health, 1941, 31: 282-4.—[Review of publications on communal sanitation] Gig. & zdorov 1941 ii: No. 5, 54-60. ---- Congress and convention. See also Health officer, Congress. American health congress. N. Y., v.l, 1926. Brasil. Congresso brasileiro de hygiene. 1. Congresso, Rio de Janeiro, 1 a 7 de Outubro de 1923. 247p. 8? Rio, 1927. Brasil. Congresso brasileiro de hygiene, Sao Paulo, 4 a 12 de Novembro de 1926. Con- ferencias pronunciadas perante o 111° Congresso brasileiro de hygiene. S. Paulo, v.3, 1927. France. Congres de la sante publique. 3. Congr., Marseille, Sept. 11-17, 1922. Rapports. 542p. 24cm. Marseille, 1922. International congress of sanitary engi- neering AND URBAN HYGIENE. 2. Congr., Milano, April 20-25, 1931. 3v. 30cm. Milano, 1931. NEDERLANDSCH CONGRES VOOR OPENBARE, gezondheidsregeling. 's Gravenhage, Oct. 2-3, 1936. Handelingen. 259p. 24^cm. Zwolle, 1936. Pan American sanitary conference. 5. Conf., Santiago de Chile, Nov. 5-11, 1911. Transactions. 163p. 2Sy2cm. Wash. [1911] [Panamerican] Conferencia sanitaria Pan- americana. Actas de la novena conferencia sanitaria Panamericana, celebrada en Buenos Aires del 12 al 22 de noviembre dc 1934. 525p. 8? Wash., 1935. [Panamerican Sanitary Conference] 10. Conf., Acte final. 15p. 24^cm. Wash., 1939. Panamerican Sanitary Conference. 10. Conf., Acta final. 17p. 25cm. Wash., 1938. Panamerican Sanitary Conference. Dixieme conference sanitaire panamericaine: acte final [French ed.] 15p. 24^cm. Wash., 1939. Paz Soldan, C. E. Al servicio de la higiene Americana. 160p. 8? Lima, 1925. Seventh-day Adventists. General con- ference. Principles of healthful living. 191p. 20cm. Wash. [1940] [Spain] Congreso nacional de sanidad. 1. Congr., Madrid, May 6-12, 1934. 2v. 506p; 501p. 25cm. Madr., 1935. Trudi Odinnatzotogo Vsessouznogo Sezda Bakteriologov, Epidemiologov, i Sanitarnykh Vrachei [Work of the eleventh all union Congress of bacteriologists, epidemiologists and sanitation physicians] Moskva, 1929. Venezuela. Conferencia sanitaria na- cional. 2. Reuni6n, Caracas, Dec. 19-22, 1931 [Relatos oficiales] 691p. 31cm. Caracas, 1932. Venezuela. Ministerio de Sanidad _y Asistencia Social. Memoria que el Ministerio de Sanidad y Asistencia Social presenta al Congreso nacional en sus sesiones de 1937. 995p. 32cm. Caracas, 1937. , Acta general del Primer Congreso sanitario de Centro- America v PanamA. Bol. san. Guatemala, 1938, 9: &-25.— Allen, A. T., Brooks, E. C. [et al.] A symposium presented to Section of Public Health and Education, Medical Society of the State of North Carolina. South. M. & S., 1930. 92: 389-405. Alocuriones de los Jefes delas Delegaciones al Primer Congresso Sanitario de Centro America y Panama P™™™^,?* «J >» sesi6n inaugural. Bol. san. Guatemala, 1938, 9: 506-10 — HYGIENE, PUBLIC 040 HYGIENE, PUBLIC Vltmever. A. J. The national health conference and the future'of public health. Am. J. Pub. Health. 1939, 29: 1-10.— Ante el Congreso Sanitario de Centro America y Panamd. Bol. san. Guatemala, 1938, 9: 496-S.—Bauer. \V. W. Healthier health meetings. Am. J. Pub. Health, 1940, 30: 523-6.— Ilorruat, A. Wlhesiones recibidas por la presidencia del D. N. H con motivo de algunas medidas adoptadas: Congreso de -anidad de >anta Ei. Bol. san., B. Air., 1939, 3: No. S. 565.— Ilregcr, J. Zur Internationalen Sanitats-Konferenz, Paris 1926. \rb. Keichsgesundhamt., 1926, 57: 629-51.—Brusco, L. D., & Ktchepare, J. Octavo Conferencia sanitaria panamericana Lima. 12-21 ideOctubrede 1927) Bol. Cons. nac. hig., Montev. 1927, 22: 573-608.—Cailleux, M. Dictaturo et latinite; 3" congres, joie et travail; Juin 1938, Rome. Rev. mid. sociale, Par., 1939, 7: 73; 130.—Carrington, W. J. The New Jersey conference on health and welfare. Bull. M. Soc. Cape May Co 1940 2: Xo. 10, 3.—Celebracion del Dfa panamericano de la salud en Barranquilla. Rev. hig., Bogot A, 1941, 22: 19-31 — Charria Tovar, R. Clausura de la Asamhlea medical del Cauca. Ibid. 52-9— Chatterjee, A. C. All Bengal public health con- ference; fifth session. Ind. M. Rec, 1939, 59: 172-80.—Como se Integra el personal del Congreso de la Sanidad. Bol. san. Guatemala, 1938, 9: 514.—Conferencia (I.) nacionaldeeducacflo e saude. Brasil med., 1941, 55: 619-21.—Conferencia (La) sanitaria nacional. Bol. educ. san., Caracas, 1941, 5: No. 78, ].—Conferencia (IX.) sanitaria panamericana. Brasil med., 1941, 55: No. 38. p. x.—Conferencia (A) de 1940 da reparticao sanitaria panamericana, Impr. med., Rio, 1941, 17: No. 334, 127-30.—Conferencia (XI.) sanitdria panamericana. Gaz. clin., S Paulo 1941, 39: 395.—Conferencia sanitaria panamericana (Buenos Aires, 1934) Bol. salud pub., Montev., 1934, 3: 439- 515.—Conferencias y congresos sanitarios nacionales e inter- nacionales. In Memoria (Venezuela Min. san.) Caracas, 1937, 13-5.—Congres d'hygiene, Paris. Presse med., 1924, 32: 974-8—Congrfes (XXV«) d'Hygidne, Paris, 21 Novembre-ler Dicembre 1938. Ibid., 1938, 46: 103-6.—Congres (XXVI.) d'hygiene, Institut Pasteur, 9-12 octobre 193'.); questions mises k l'ordre du jour. Rev. hyg., Par., 1939, 61: -189.--Congres (XIIB) international d'hygiene et de demographie tenu k Bruxelles du 2 au 8 septembre 1903. Ann. pharm., Louvain, 1903, 9: 461-5.—Congresso (VI.) de higiene. Brasil med., 1942, 56: No. 8, 17.—Congresso (VI.) nazionale Palermo 11, 12, 13, 14 ottobre. Italia san., 1908, 4: 246.—Congreso (El) Sanitario de Centro-Am6rica y Panamd. Bol. san. Guatemala, 1938 9: 524-6.—Cozens-Hardy. Presidential address [to the British Health Congress! Nat. Health Rev., Ottawa, 1938, 6: 91.—Cuarta sesi6n cientifica del Congreso Sanitario, proyecto de' cddigo para menores comentado favorablemente por los delegados. Bol. san. Guatemala, 193s, 9: 552 1.—dimming, H. S. The International Sanitary Conference. Am. .1. Pub. Health, 1926. 16: 975-80. ---- - International Sanitary Conference formulates advances. Nations Health, Chic, 1926, 8: 59-1 6. Cumpston, J. H. L. La seconde conference sanitaire internationale du Pacifique reunie, k Sydney, du 3 au 6 septenibre 1935. Bull. Off. internat. hyg. pub., 1936, 28: 257-62.—Decima Conferencia Sanitaria Panamericana, cele- brada en Bogotd, Colombia, septiembre 4-14, 1938; acta final. Bol. Of. san. pananiei., 1938, 17: 958; 1067.—Decima Con- ferencia Sanitaria Panamericana; resumen de sus labores. Ibid., 1939, 18: 29; 112; 220.—Emerson, K. The ninth Pan- American sanitary conference. Am. J. Pub. Health, 1935, 25: 76-80.—Esplcndida inauguraci6n del Congreso. Bol. san. Guatemala, 1938, 9: 493.—Fenton, J. Public lecture to the South African health congress. J. R. San. Inst., 1935-36, 56: 640-7.—Forum discussion marks 20th annual Conference of health commissioners held in Columbus, December 14-15. Ohio M. J., 1940, 36: 88.—Gaitan, L. Primer congreso sani- tario de Centro Am6rica y Panamd. Bol. Of. san. panamer., 1938 17: 95-9, portr.—Gautier. Conferencia sanitaria pan- africana Johannesburgo, 20-30 noviembre 1935. Med. ibera, 1936 30: pt 2, 257-63.—Goncalves Braga, A. A. A conferencia sanitdria internacional de Paris de 1911-12. Arq. Inst, centr. hig., Lisb., 1916, 2: 16-65.—Goodman, N. M. Summary of proceedings at the October 1938 session of the Permanent Committee. Office international d'hygiene publique. Bull. Hyg., Lond., 1939, 14: 183-9.—Gurevich, S. A. [Scientific work conference of state sanitation inspectors of Moscow, February, 10-11, 1941, Moscow] Gig. & zdorov., 1941, 6: No. 5, 78-80.— Gutierrez, A. Un precursore del nostro congresso. Riv. Soc. ital. igiene, 1940, 62: 17.—Harewood. Inaugural address to the health congress at Scarborough. J. R. San. Inst., 1939-40, 60: 43.—Health congress at Bristol. Ibid., 1934, 55: 53-8.— Health congress at Scarborough, 1939. Ibid., 1939-40, 60: 37-42.—Health congress at Scarborough, 1939; presidential address Ibid., 273-7.—Health conferences in Washington. Health Off., Wash., 1938. 2: 599-607.—Holtom, E. C. Some impressions of the health conference at Southport. J. R. Nav. M Serv., 1937, 23: 238-50.—Hoy termina el Primer Congress Sanitario: se dara lectura a las conclusiones, hoy 21 horas; las ultimas sesiones cientificas, interesantes sugestiones del Doctor Escalante; la declaraci6n obligatoria del embarazo; pelicula sobre saneamiento de el Salvador. Bol. san. Guatemala, 1938, 9: 554.—Instalado el I Congreso Sanitario del Istmo; solemne ucto de inauguraci6n hoy. Bol. san. Guatemala, 1938, 9: 481-5 —International Pacific health conference, Sydney, 1935. Health Melb., 1935, 13: 63.—Introduction of Pan-American delegates. Proc. Conf. Health Author. N. America, 1940, 55. „ieer", in.—Jbankov, D. [Medical and correlated medico- sanitlirv conventions of the past (1861-1921)] Vrach. delo, 1927, 10: 1289-96.- -lost, A. C. Report on national health council meeting. Proc. Conf. Health Author. N. America, 1938, 53: 59.—Kansas Cn\ invites you. Am. J. Pub. Health, 1938, 28: 670-6.—Leon, K. La dixidme Conference sanitaire pananfericaine. Bull. Serv. hyg., Port-au-Prince, 1938, 5; No. 18-19, 5-53.—Leverhulme, Viscount. The Royal Institute of Public lleahli, che La-tl">uine Congress, 1933, Tuesday May 30th to Sundav. June uh (Whitsuntide) J. State M., Lond., 1933, 41: 373-9. Lloyd. 11. J. La novena conferencia sanitaria Panamericana. I'."l. Of. san. panamer., 1935, 14: 612-6. ------ The first national conference of public health workers of the Republic of Mexico. Health Off., Wash., 1937, 2: 282-6. ------ The ninth Pan American sanitary con- ference. Bull. Panamer. Union, 1935, 69: 435-4 L Mahaflcy, J. L. National health conference. Pub. Health News. Trenton, 1939, 23: 4-10.—MarzeiefT, A. [Sixth All-Ukrainian Sanilan Soviets' Convention] Profil. med., Kharkov, 1927, (\: 140-8.— Medical conference on public health problems in New Zealand. N. Zealand M. J.. 1940, 39: 339-43.—Morin, H. G. S. La troisieme congrds colonial de la santi publique. J. m6d. Bordeaux, 1922, 52: 641-52.—National (The) health con- ference. .1. Pediat., S. Louis, 1938, 13: 400-16.—[Netherlands (22d) Congress for Public Health regulations, 7-8 September, 1917, at Alkmaar] Tschr. sociale hyg., 1917, 19: 193-5.— Neuvieme (La) conference sanitaire Fananfericaine (Buenos- Aires, 12-22 novembre 1934) resunfe des principales resolutions adoptees par la Conference d'aprSs les informations communi- quees au Comit(5 permanent de l'Office International d'Hygidne publique. Bull. Off. internat. hyg. pub., Par., 1935, 27: 1097- 107.—Neveu, R. Les journdes internationales de la sanfe publique (29 juin-10 juillet 1937) Ann. hyg., Par., 1937, n. ser., 15: 385, 442.—Nomina de los trabajos entregados a la Secre- taria de Sanidad Publica para ser presentados al Primer Con- greso de Centro America y Panamd. Bol. san. Guatemala, 1938, 9: 26-9.—Novena conferencia sanitaria panamericana, 1934. Bol. Of. san. panamer., 1935,14:1-20. Official delegates to the Fifth international sanitary conference of American republics, held at Santiago, Chile, November 5-12, 1911 [Group portrait] Tr. Internat. San. Conf. Am. Repub., 1911, 5. Conf., front.—Orenstein, A. J. South African Medical Congress, 1922, Public Health Section; a brief review of some new landmarks in public health. Med. J. S. Africa, 1922-23, 18: 192-7 —Otto, R. Die internationale Sanitiitskonferenz zu Paris (10. V. bis 21. VII. 1926) Deut. med. Wschr., 1926, 52: 1694-6.—Palermo (A) inaugurandosi il congresso; la mattina dell'undici ottobre; nell'Aula Magna dell'Universitd. Italia san., 1908, 4: 259; 278.—Pan-African health conference. Brit. M. J., 1936, 1: 122.—Parran, T. The Tenth Pan American Sanitary Conference; Bogota, Colombia, September 4-14, 1938. Bull. Panamer. Union, 1938, 72: 688-94. Also Health Off., Wash., 1938, 3: 200-7.—Portsmouth and Southsea; place of meeting for the Health Congress and exhibition of the Institute, July llth-lOth, 1938. J. R. San. Inst., 1937-38, 58: Suppl., 165-82.—Preliminary program of the scientific sessions of the 70th annual meeting of the American Public Health Associa- tion, and meetings of related organizations, and of the eighth Institute on Public Health Education, Atlantic City, N. J., October 11-17, 1941. Am. J. Pub. Health, 1941, 31: 856-85 — Primer Congreso Nacional de Sanidad. Arch, med., Madr., 1934, 37: 529; 630.—Primer Congreso sanitario de Centro- Anferica y Panama. Bol. san. Guatemala, 1938, 9: 5; 499; 512.—Programa de la sesion inaugural del Primer Congreso sanitario de Centro America y Panamd, el dfa 17 de noviembre del afio de 1937. Ibid., 32; 36.—Quedo clausurado el Congreso Sanitario con trascendentales conclusiones; expresa voto de graiitud al Presidente Ubico y Gobiernos Istmicos; el segundo Congreso serd en San Jos6 de Costa Rica; saldo cientifico. Ibid., 571-3.—Recomendaciones de la seccion de salubridad y meciicima del 8. Congreso cientifico americano. Gac. mid. Mexico, 1940, 70: 648-50.—Reglamento para el Primer Con- greso sanitario de Centro America y Panamd, que se celebrard en la capital de Guatemala, durante los dias 17, 18, 19 y 20 de noviembre de 1937. Bol. san. Guatemala, 1938, 9: 30.— Report of the Pan-African health conference. Q. Bull. Health Org. League of Nat., 1936, 5: 1-7.—[Report of the 2lst Congress for Public Health regulations, decreed on the 15th and 16th of September, 1916, at Leeuwarden, in the council chamber of the Town-Hall] Tschr. social hyg., 1917, 19: 4; 40.—[Report of the 22nd Congress for Public Health Regulations, decreed on September 7-8, 1917, in the council-chamber of the Town- Hall at Alkmaar] Ibid., 233; 265; 289.—Royal Sanitary Insti- tute. Bournemouth; place of meeting for the Health Congress and exhibition of the Institute, July 15th to 20th, 1935. J. R. San. Inst., 1934-35, 55: Suppl., 163-82.—Schwitalla, A. M. The National Health Conference, Washington, D. C, July 18, 19, and 20, 1938. Hosp. Progr., 1938, 19: 239-90.—Second (The) international Pacific Health Conference, 1935. Health, Melb., 1935, 13: 129-34.—Segunda (La) sesi6n cientifica de la Conferencia Sanitaria. Bol. san. Guatemala, 1938, 9: 515; 520.—Sesion de clausura del Primer Congreso Sanitario Centroamericano y de Panamd, celebrada en el Palacio de Sanidad Publica de Guatemala, el 20 de noviembre de 1937, bajo la Presidencia del Jefe de la Delegaci6n de Guatemala, Doctor Carlos Estevez. Ibid., 434-6.—Sesion preliminar a la inaugural del Congreso Centro-americano. Ibid., 494.— Seventh session of the National Health and Medical Research HYGIENE, PUBLIC 941 HYGIENE, PUBLIC Council. Health, Canberra, 1939, 17: 129-33.—Solemne apertura del Congreso Sanitario; ceremonies de esta mafiana en el Palacio de Sanidad publica. Bol. san. Guatemala, 1938, 9: 486-92.—Solemne inauguraci6n del Primer Congreso Sanitario Centroamericano y de Panamd. Ibid., 475-80.— Solemnemente se celebr6 en Bogota el Dfa de la salud. Rev. hig., Bogotd, 1941, 22: 8-18, pl.—Some resolutions of the Tenth Pan American Sanitary Conference in Bogotd, Colombia September 4-14, 1938. Pub. Health Rep., Wash., 1938, 53': 1975-7.—Spangenberg. Ecos del Congreso de sanidad de Santa Fe. Action m<5d., B. Air., 1939, 9: 542.—Special session of the House of delegates in Chicago. J. Iowa M. Soc, 1938 28: 494-6.—Spencer, R. R. Highlights of a great health congress. Health Off., Wash., 1937, 2: 255-8.—Spranger. Die Panamerikanischen Sanitatskonferenzen mit Bericht iiber die IX. vom November 1934. Reichs-Gesundhbl., 1935, 10: 304.—Trabalhos do III Congresso Brasileiro de Hygiene realizado em Sao Paulo, em 1926. Arch, hyg., S. Paulo, 1937, 2: No. 3, 525-9.—Tenth (The) Pan American sanitary con- ference. J. Am. M. Ass., 1939, 112: 1258-60.—Tenth Pan American Sanitary Conference, held in the city of Bogotil, Colombia, September 4-14, 1938. Bol. Of. san. panamer., 1939] 18: 11; 411.—Twenty-fifth hygiene congress; Paris. J. Am. m! Ass., 1938, 111: 461.—Twenty-ninth annual meeting Fort Garry Hotel, Winnipeg, September 19-21. Canad. Pub. Health J., 1940, 31: 298-301.— U. S. Public Health Service. The ninth Pan American sanitary Conference held at Buenos Aires, Argentina, Nov. 12-22, 1934. Pub. Health Rep., Wash., 1935, 50: 1168-75. ------ Report of Dr Hugh S. Cumming, director of the Pan American Sanitary Bureau, to the ninth Pan American Sanitary Conference. Ibid., 1175- 83.—Violle, H. Congres international d'hygieine mecliter- raneenne; Marseille, 20 k 25 septembre 1932. J. Egypt. M. Ass., 1932, 15: 124.—Votos del Congreso. Actas Congr. nac. san., Madr. (1934) 1935, 1. Congr., 4: 413-26.—Willcox, W. F. Statistics at the fourteenth International Congress on Hygiene and Demography, Berlin, Sept. 23-29, 1907. Pub. Am. Statist. Ass., Bost., 1912, 13: 191-228.—Yaros, R. The National Health Conference. Med. Woman J., 1938, 45: 311-3. ---- Essays. Chapin, C. V. Papers of Charles V. Chapin, M. D.; a review of public health realities. 244p. 8° N. Y., 1934. Hygienische und biologische Abhand- ltjngen, unter Berucksichtigung der physio- chemischen, serologischen und bakteriologischen Grenzgebiete; Hermann Griesbach zum 70. Geburtstag, gewidmet von Freunden, Kollegen und Schiilern. 152p. 8? Giessen, 1925. Pennsylvania. University. Bicentennial Conference. The university and public health statesmanship. 33p. 23cm. Phila., 1941. Archinard, L. Importance £conomique et sociale des travaux d'hygidne. Techn. san. mun., Par., 1934, 29: 287.— Balfour, G. J. G. B. Presidential address to the South African health congress. J. R. San. Inst., 1935-36, 56: 631-9 — Bocobo, J. Address. Month. Bull. Bur. Health, Manila, 1939, 19:198.—Browning, G. Address. Papers Health Work. Conf. Tennessee, 1938, 10: 2-5.—Burgers. Die Beziehungen der Hygiene zu Naturwissenschaften und praktischer Medizin. Klin Wschr., 1926, 5: 1802-4.—Corbett, J. E. A statement on public health—public relations. Optic. J., 1941, 78: No. 20, 25.—Entrevista (Una) con el Dr. Garcia Alvdrez; importantes declaraciones del Sen or Ministro de sanidad y asistencia social. Bol. educ. san., Caracas, 1940, 3: No. 61, 3—Fabella, J. Address delivered by the honorable Commissioner of Health and Welfare, on January 25, 1939. Month. Bull. Bur. Health, Manila 1939,19:115-8.—Fremantle, F. Presidential address. J. R San. Inst., 1932, 53: 85.—Hannah, W. Address. Rep. Conf. Tennessee Health Work, 1932, 5: 24.—Hoag, E. B. What women can do for sanitary science. Los Angeles M. J., 1905, 2: 319-23.—Hobday, F. T. G. Hygiene and preventive medicine. J. R. San. Inst., 1928-29, 49: 309-12.—Iriondo, M. M. de. Desarrollo de la conciencia higienica. Bol. Of. san panamer., 1940, 19: 126.—Lopez Jimenez, R. ProposiciOn del delegado de la Universidad Nacional de EI Salvador. Bol. san. Guatemala, 1938, 9: 239.—Mandamientos de la higiene (Hencourt) Rev. med. contemp. Madr., 1910, 32: H6-8.— Mangiagalli, L. Verso la luce. Italia san., 1908 4: 185.— Moll, A. A. Mensaje a la Sanidad de Centro-Amgnca. Bol. san. Guatemala, 1938, 9: 402-4 -Nicoll.M jr. Public health aphorisms. N. York State J. M., 1924, 24: 939.—Bay, T. R. Address. Rep. Conf. Tennessee Health Work, 1932, 5: [Discussion] 26-9.—Riley, R. H. Address of the president. Proc. Conf. Health Author. N. America, 1938, 53: l?-^*.— Schwitalla, A. M. The president's address of the twenty- second annual convention. Hosp. Progr., 1937, 18: 200-10.— Soto, C. E., Arenales, P., Carrillo, L. A., & Lopez, H. E. Sugestiones que hace la Facultad de CC. NN. y Farmacia de Guatemala. Bol. san. Guatemala, 1938, 9: 286-9.—Spencer, R R & Pritchard, E. G. Animal, vegetable, or mineral. Health Off., Wash., 1937, 2: 65-73—Tanon. L'orientation de l'hygiene moderne. Ann. hyg., Par., 1929, n. ser., 7: 1-22.— Vaughan, H. F. The way of public health. Tr. Coll. Physicians Philadelphia, 1941, 9: 86-95.—Wheatley, J. Words of welcome. Ir. Internat. Conf. San. Engin., 1924, 1. Congr., 30.—Williams, W. C. Commissioner's address. Papers Health Work. Conf. Tennessee, 1937, 9: 172; 1938, 10: 211. ---- Exposition. Bermudez, S. La obra sanitaria en la Feria mundial do Nueva l ork. Gac. med. Mexico, 1941, 71: 281-302.—Burgers. Ziele und Erfolge der Gesolei. Zschr. Desinfekt., 1926, 18: 159-61.—Calver, H. N. Scientific exhibits. Am. J. Pub. Health, 1942, 32: No. 3, Suppl., 54-61 .—Dunham, G. C. The International Hygiene Exhibition. Ibid., 1931, 21: 1-10. ------ The International Hygiene Exhibition, Dresden, Germany. Mil. Surgeon, 1931, G8: 169-78.—Esposizione austriaca delle istituzioni per la salute pubblica in Vienna del 1898. Gior. farm., Trieste, 1896, 1: 189.—Exposition interna- tionale de Paris. Ann. pharm., Louvain, 1904, 10: 183.— Fischer, A. Zur Geschichte der Hygieneausstellungen. Deut. med. Wschr., 1935, 61: 1365-7.—Garrison, F. H. The Gesolei at Diisseldorf. Bull. N. York Acad. Sc, 1927, 3: 1-6.— Gartner, A. Die Gesolei in Diisseldorf. Gesundh. Ingenieur, 1926, 49: 373-6.—Gaumitz, H. Wohnung, Siedlung, Stadte- bau und Landesplanung auf der Gesolei. Ibid., 677-80.— Inauguration de la section de l'hygiene et de la bienfaisance k l'exposition de Bruxelles. Mouvement hyg., Brux., 1910, 26: 187-97.—Libanio, S. Stand de sdude publica no pavilhao do Brasil na exposicao do mundo Portugu&s, Lisboa, 1940. Bol. Of. san. panamer., 1940, 19: 1114.—Medical science and public health at the World's fairs. Trained Nurse, 1939, 102: 430-7.— Mielcarzewicz, T. [Impressions from International Exposition of Hygiene in Dresden] Nowiny psychjat., 1933, 10: 1—10.— Neustatter, O. Die grosse Ausstellung fur Gesundheitspflege, soziale Fiirsorge und Leibesubungen, Diisseldorf 1926. Miinch. med. Wschr., 1926, 73: 1278; 1447.—Pavilion (Le) de l'hygiene. Presse m6d., 1937, 45: 954.—Schlossmann, A. Die Gesolei. Umschau, 1926, 30: 589.—Tomasek, V. [Health exposition in Brno] Cas. 16k. desk., 1926, 65: 1499; 1544.—Winkel, M. Volksernahrung auf der Gesolei. Zschr. Desinfekt., 1926, 18: 161-3.—Zhdanova, N. P. [Sanitary-hygienic exhibits at the Pan-Union agricultural exposition] Gig. & zdorov., 1941, 6: No. 5, 51-4. ---- History. Le Buanec, J. ^Considerations historiques et critiques sur les coutumes, mceurs et pr6juge\s d'Armorique en matiere d'hygiene. 52p. 8? Par., 1931. Rtjmpe, R. Die Gesundheitspflege in der Rheinprovinz; eine medizingeschichtliche Studie. 8? Jena, 1931. Schiaffino, R. La sanidad en Canada, Italia y Alemania. 96p. 8? Montev., 1926. Seitz, F. X. *Beitrage zur Geschichte der Hygiene und Medicinal-Polizei. 90p. 8? Ziir., 1883. Alley, R. G. Some historical facts leading up to our modern pubhc ideals. Clifton M. Bull., 1927-28, 13: 74-9.—Campbell, P. S. Public health progress; presidential address. Canad. Pub. Health J., 1938, 29: 321-4.—Celli-Fraentzel, A. Comment la Gaule, civilisfie par Rome, se d6voua k I'assainissement de Rome, au moyen &ge et dans les temps modernes. Arch. Inst. Pasteur Algerie, 1929, 7: 239-86, 29 pl.—Cumming, H. S. Hygiene, preventive medicine, and public health since 1891. Internat. Clin., 1928, 38. ser., 2: 271-91— Desenvolvimiento de la sanidad de policfa en sus aspectos t^cnicoy administrative; sus relaciones con el exterior; algunos datos para la historia de la sanidad de policfa. Rev. san. policfa, Lima, 1941, 1: 298.— Earp, J. R. The history of public health. N. York State J. M., 1938, 38: 1151-7.—Emerson, H. Signs of the times in public health. J. Am. M. Ass., 1939, 112: 737-9.—Fitz, R. From cow-path to state road. N. England J. M., 1936, 214, 24: 1178-88.—Galdston, I. Humanism and pubhc health, Bull. Hist. M., 1940, 8: 1032-9.—Illingworth Icaza, J. La sanidad en el Litoral. Bol. Of. san. panamer., 1936, 15: 103- 5.—Kinnaman, J. H. Milestones in public health, 1880-1934. J. Iowa M. Soc, 1936, 26: 117.—Leathers, W. S. Recent advances in public health. Bicent. Conf. Univ. Pennsylvania, Univ. & Pub. Health, 1941, 11-20. Also Texas J. M., 1941-42, 37: 549-52.—Mahaffey, J. L. The year in review. Pub. Health News, Trenton, 1941, 25: 195-201.—Miller, K. E. The evolution of public health. Health Off., Wash., 1937, 2: 353-62.—Mustard, H. S. The past; laying the foundation. Bicent. Conf. Univ. Pennsylvania, Univ. & Pub. Health, 1941, 5_10.—Nicoll, M. The age of public health. N. York State J M , 1927, 27: 114-6.—Oldershaw, H. L. History of public health. J. R. Inst. Pub. Health, 1937-38, 1: 361-71.—Oliver, T. Respice et prospice. Ibid., 509-13.—Palkin, M. E. [Public health under the Paris Commune] Medicina, Kaunas, 1941, 22: 317-27.—Panel, G. Iconographie medicale normande; une question d'hygiene; rue Martainville k la fin du XVIe siecle. Rev. med. Normandie, 1905, 224-9, pl.—Parran, T. Reporting progress. Am. J. Pub. Health, 1936, 26: 1071-6.— HYGIENE, PUBLIC 942 HYGIENE, PUBLIC aus Anlass 218p. 4! I'irquct. FoitM'hritle der Hvgiene in den letzten 80 Jahren. Klin. W schr.. 1927. 6: 2357.—Porter, G. 1). Some of the great ronliibutions to pubhc health. Pub. Health J., Toronto, 1928, 19: 501-4.—Potts, ( . Twenty-five vears of sanitary progress. Pub. Health News, Trenton, 1940, 24: 131-46. Rutland, S. C. Public health progress. J. M. Ass. Georgia, 1939. 28: 367-70 — Sahagiin Torres. J. La experiencia sanitaria de Santa Teresa del Tuy. Hev. san., Caracas, 1941, 6: 898-927. Scares, J. A hygiene d'Aveiro. Porto med., 1940, 1: 208.— Shryock, R. H. Die Medizin und die Entwicklung der offentlichen Gesundheitspflege, 1800-80. In his Entw. mod. Med., Stuttg., 1940, 172-202.—Smillie, W. G. The development of public health in America. Illinois Health Mess., 1939, 11: 57-61.— Stapley, F. Some notes on metropolitan development. Health Bull., Moll... 1934, Nos 37-38, 1118-20—Techoueyres, E. La bienfaisante influence de l'hygiene sur la diminution de la mortality et la prolongation de la vie. Paris mdd., 1934, 93: 136-8.—Varron, A. G. Hygiene in the medieval city. Ciba Symposia, 1939-40, 1: 205-14. ---- Institute. See also Health laboratory. Calcutta. All-India Institute of Hygiene and Public Health. Annual report. Calc, 1934-35. Charlotte, N. C. Duke Endowment. The Duke Endowment year book. No. 9. 45p. 23!,cm. Charlotte, N. C. [1941] Chicago. Public Health Institute. An- nual report of the Public Health Institute of Chicago, for the year ended December 31, 1931. 23p. 8? [Chic, 1932] Cuba. Servkto tecnico de salubridad. Informes. Habana, v.l, 1937- Czechoslovakia. Institut d'hygiene pu- blique. Travaux. Praha, v.l, 1930- Germany. Reichsgesundheitsamt. Das Reichsgesundheitsamt 1876-1926; Festschrift hrsg. vom Reichsgesundheitsamt seines fiinfzigjahrigen Bestehens. Berl., 1926. H., D. P. Hygiene museums; a suggestive sketch for the complete illustration of hygiene. 26p. 8? Hornsey [London] [n. d.] Hungary. OrszAgos Kozegeszsegugyi Inte- zet. JelentSs. Budap., 9. (1935) 1936- John Hopkins University. School of Hygiene and Public Health. De Lamar lec- tures. 1925-26- ---- Report of the activities. Bait., 1928/29- ---- Collected papers, v. 11, 1929-30- Lisboa. Instituto central de higiene. Arquivos. Lisb., v.1-2, 1913-16. London. Royal Institute of Public Health. Journal. Lond., v.l, 1937- London. Royal Sanitary Institute. Kal- endar. Lond., 1931- London, Canada. University of Western Ontario. Institute of Public Health. An- nual report. Lond., 22., 1933/34- Mexico, D. F. Instituto de salubridad y enfermedades tropicales. Revista. Mex., v.l, No. 1, 1939. Michigan University. Division of Hy- giene and Public Health. Public health reviews. Ann Arb., v.4, 1934- New York, N. Y. Josiah Macy, Jr., Founda- tion. A review by the president of activities for the 4 years ended December 31, 1940, with ex- tracts from the treasurer's report for the years 1937-40. 125p. 23cm. N. Y., 1941. New York, N. Y. Milbank Memorial Fund. Proceedings of the 19. annual conference, April 29-30, 1941. 28p. 23^cm. [X. Y.] 1941. Pan American Sanitary Bureau. Annual report of the director. Wash., 1938-39- Prussia. Ministeriums des Innern. Vor- trage und Arbeiten aus dem Gebiete des Polizei- snnitatswesen 1933. Bd 3. 267p. S? Berl. 1934. Seiking. The Central Institution for Public Hygiene. ISp. 8? Dresd., 1930. Simon, C. E. The School of Hygiene and Public Health of the Johns Hopkins University. 5op. S? Bait,, 1926. Sydney University. School of Prune Health and Tropical Medicine. Service publication No. 1. New South Wales, 1(131 Yale University. School of medicine. Department of public health. Contributions from the Anna M. R. Lauder Department of Public Health, Yale University School of medicine, v.16, 1937-39. v. p. 24>4cm. [New Haven, 1939] All-India (An) institute of public health; the Rockefeller gift. Lancet, Lond., 1931, 1: 611. Also Ind. M. Gaz., 1931, R6: 154-7. Also Med. Off., Lond., 1930, 56: 229. Also Rrit. M. J., 1936, 2: 1108. Also Med. Leg. Crim. Rev., Lond., 1940, 8: 215.—Ampil, F. La Escuela de Higiene y Sanitacion Publica y el Servicio de sanidad publica de las Islas Filipinas; la educaci6n sanitaria es el medio para dar tdrmino a los problemas de sanitation publica en las Islas Filipinas. Rev. filip. med., 1925, 16: 159; 183.—Ankara (The) Institute and School of Hygiene. Bull. Health Org. League of Nat., 1938, 7: 231-47.—Annual report of the All-India Institute of Hygiene and Public Health for the vears 1937-38. Annual Rep. All India Inst. Hyg., Calc. (1937) 1938, 5-11; (1938) 1939, 5-12 \lso Analyst, Lond., 1940, 65: 225.—Athens (The) School of Hygiene. Bull. Health Org. League of Nat., 1938, 7: 248-63.— Uaecher, S. [The immunobio'ogical section of the Turkish Central Hygiene Institute] Turk hifzissihha tecr. biyol mecmuasi, 1938-39, 1: 57-86.—Beninde, M. Die Preussische Landesanstalt fiir Wasser-, Boden- und Lufthygiene zu Berlin- Dahlem im Laufe der Zeiten. Veroff. Medverwalt., 1926, 21 • 785-844, 4 maps; 1927, 23: 383.—Bock, A. V., & Oliver, H. K. The Department of Hygiene. Bull. Harvard M. Alumni, 1937, 11: 57-62.—Bonjean, M. L'institut d'hygiene du Maroc Rev. hyg., Par., 1935, 57: 734-51.—Budapest (The) Institute of Hygiene. Bull. Health Org. League of Nat., 1938, 7: 264- 78.—Cumming, H. S. The National Institute of Health of the United States Public Health Service. J. Indust. Hyg., 1931, 13: 1-3.—Evrot. L'dcole d'hygidne et de sant<5 publique rle I'Universitd Johns Hopkins, k Baltimore. Rev. hvg., Par 1927, 49: 330-47.—Feier (Die) des 60jahrigcn Bestehens des Reichsgesundbeitsamts. Reichsgesundhbl., 1930, 11: 669-79.— Ferrell. J. A. The International Health Division of the Rocke- feller Foundation. Proc. Conf. Health Author. N. America, 1940, 55. meet., 17.—Fracastoro, Ramazzini; aus der Ehren- halle grosser Aerzte im Deutschen Hygiene-Museum zu Dresden. Fortsch. Med., 1932, 50: 465-9.—Freudenthal, P. [Hygienic institutes] Ugeskr. laeger, 1940, 102: 1369; 1941. 103: 51.—Fiinfzig (Zum) jahrigen Bestehen des Reichsge- sundheitsamtes. Apoth. Ztg, 1926, 41: 671-4.—Gotschlich, E. [The aims of the Turkish Central Hygiene Institute in Ankara] Turk hifzissihha tecr. biyol. mecmuasi, 1938-39, 1: 8-19.— Haendel, L. Reichsgesundheitsamt und wissenschaftlichc Forschung. Klin. Wschr., 1926, 5: 1377-80.—Haibe. Les instituts bactdriologiques provinciaux et l'hygi&ne. Mouve- ment hyg., Brux., 1908. 24: 297-302.—Harrington, F. E. Report of the division of health and sanitation. Annual Rep. Minneapolis Gen. Hosp., 1933, 3: 203.—History (The) of the Royal Institute of Public Health. J. State M., Lond., 1924, 32: 2; 51; 102.—Informe sobre las labores de la Secci6n de estudios especiales en el tercer trimestre de 1940. Rev. hig., BogotA, 1940, 21: No. 11, 14-39.—Institut (L') d'hygidne publique de l'Etat Tchdcoslovaque en 1931-32. Trav. Inst hyg. pub. tehee, 1932, 3: 91; 1933, 4: 1.—Institute of hvgiene established in Ecuador. J. Am. M. Ass., 1941, 117: 1109 — Institute (The) of Public Health in Sofia. Bull. Health Org League of Nat., 1938, 7: 382-5.—Institutes (The) of hvgiene in Roumania. Ibid., 358-81.—Instituto Adolfo Lutz. Arq. hig S Paulo, 1941, 6: No. 11, 300-7.—Instituto (El) Rizzoli; informe presentado por el Dr Luis Coscia al Ministro de salud public;!. Rev. san. mil., Asunci6n, 1939-40, 13: 1020-34.— Institution Royale de Messines, k Lede-lez-Alost. Bull, san pub.. Bmx., 1938, 3: 605.—Johan, B. Report about the activities of the Hungarian State Hygienic Institute during the first 5 years of its existence. Orsz. Kozegeszs. Int. kozl 1933, 6: No. 7, 1-8. —---- [Royal Hungarian Health Institute] Orv. hetil., 1927. 71: 1137-45, 8 pl.------The State hygienic institute of Hungary and its divisions. Meth. Med. Educ, 1932, 20. ser., 125-41.—Kaplun, S. I. [Scien- tific work of the sanitary faculty of the 1st Moscow medi- cal Institute] Gig. san., Moskva, 1940, 5: No. 12, 1-7.— Kavetsky, R. E. [Ten years since the founding of the Institute for Experimental Biology and Pathology of the Public Health Commissariat in Kiev] J. mdd., Kiev, 1941, 11: 5-22 — Leverhulme. The Royal Institute of Public Health; past, present and future. J. State M., Lond., 1919, 27: 258-61.— London School of Hygiene and Tropical Medicine. Bull. Health Org. League of Nat., 1938, 7: 279-308.—McCoy, G. W. HYGIENE, PUBLIC 943 HYGIENE, PUBLIC The work of the National Institute of Health. Pennsylvania M. J., 1934-35, 38: 835-40— Mayer, M., & Pifano, C. F. Relaci6n de los trabajos cientfficos verificados en el Departa- mento de investigaci6n del Instituto nacional de higiene durante los meses de Agosto a Diciembre de 1939. Rev. san., Caracas, 1940, 5: No. 1, 117-22.—Modificaciones a la constitucion y estatutos de la Oficina Sanitaria Panamericana. Bol. Of. san. panamer., 1938, 17: 967-9.—Moilers, B. Ein Halbjahrhundert Reichsgesundheitsamt; zum 30. Juni 1926. Zschr. iirztl. Fortbild., 1926, 23: 437-42. ------ Sechzig Jahre Reichs- gesundheitsamt. Arb. Reichsgesundhamt., 1936, 70: 383-99.— Molkov, A. V. [Institute of hygiene of the first Moscow medical institute as the principal base of the Faculty of sanitation] Gig. san., Moskva, 1939, 4: No. 10, 4-8.—Moll, A. A. Las grandes escuelas de sanidad del mundo. Bol. Of. san. panamer., 1936, 15: 1045-65.—Nancy (The) Institute of Hygiene. Bull. Health Org. League of Nat., 1938, 7: 313-27.—National institute for public health in Lima. J. Am. M. Ass., 1941, 117: 212.—National Institute of Hygiene, Guayaquil, Ecuador. Bol. Of. san. panamer., 1941, 20: 892, pl.—Neumayer, K. The Institute for Hygiene at Zagreb (Jugoslavia) a Rocke- feller Foundation. Hosp. Social Serv., 1929, 19: 486-8.— New (The) bureau of hygiene in Munich. J. Am. M. Ass., 1939, 113: 345.—New health institute in Costa Rica. Ibid., 1941, 116: 2097.—New laboratories for DeLamar Institute of Public Health. Ibid., 1939, 112: 2335.—Nikolaiev, J. [Scien- tific institutes, their role and value in public health system] Profil. med., Kharkov, 1927, 6: No. 10, 169-79.—Nuovo (II) Istituto di Sanitit Pubblica in Roma. Minerva med., Tor., 1935, 26: parte varia, 4.—O'Leary, P. A. The National institute of health. Proc. Mayo Clin., 1940, 15: 605-8.— Patino Camargo, L. Informe del director del Instituto Federico Lleras Acosta, 1939. Rev. hig., Bogotd, 1940, 21: No. 11, 40-8.—Pennsylvania Health Institute; schedule of lectures. Pennsylvania Health, 1940, 1: No. 10, 44-8.—Periale, M. L'Institut d'hygiene k Rabat. Paris m£d., 1933, 90: annexe, 123-9.—Poulsen, V. [Hygienic institutes] Ugeskr. laeger, 1941, 103: 90.—Prague (The) Institute of Hygiene. Bull. Health Org. League of Nat., 1938, 7: 328-43.—Public Health Research Institute of New York City, Inc.. Med. Times, N. Y., 1941, 69: 448.—Pulewka, P. [The pharmacological section of the Central Hygiene Institute in Ankara] Turk hifzissihha tecr. biyol. mecmuasi, 1938-39, 1: 87-188 —Ransdell, J. E. The National Institute of Health. Radiology, 1932, 18: 942- 7.—Reiter. Wege und Ziele des Reichsgesundheitsamts nach der Machtubernahme. Reichsgesundhbl., 1936, 11: 506-9.— Rimpau, W. Zum fiinfzigjahrigen Bestehen des Deutschen Reichs-Gesundheitsamtes. Miinch. med. Wschr., 1926, 73: 1057-60.—Roiek, J., & Vacek, B. Les oeuvres et l'organisa- tion de l'lnstitut d'hygidne publique de la Republique Tch6co- slovaque. Trav. Inst. hyg. pub. tehic, 1930, 1: 2-8.—Rome (The) Institute of Public Health. Bull. Health Org. League of Nat., 1938, 7: 344-57.—Rost, E. Das Reichsgesundheits- amt, 1876-1926. Med. Klin., BerL, 1926, 22: 1095.—Royal (The) Institute of Public Health and the Institute of Hygiene; the Edinburgh Congress, 1936. J. State M., Lond., 1936, 44: 311-5.—Rubner. Die Mitarbeit von Reichsgesundheitsamt und Reichsgesundheitsrat an der Wohlfahrt des deutschen Volkes in den letzten 50 Jahren. Deut. med. Wschr., 1926, 52: 1520; 1562.—Savonen, S. [Hygiene schools in Europe and the founding of an Institute in Finland for the promotion of Public Health] Duodecim, Helsinki, 1938, 54: 387-98 — Schmidt, P. Neue Aufgaben fiir die hygienischen Institute. Med. Klin., BerL, 1928, 24: 604.—Schutt, E. Sechzig Jahre Reichsgesundheitsamt. Oeff. Gesundhdienst, 1936-37, 2: A, 355-60.—Scientific institutions in Latin America; Institute of Public Health and Tropical Diseases. Bol. Of. san. panamer. 1941, 20: 150-2.—Second general report on certain European schools and institutes of hygiene. Bull. Health Org. League of Nat., 1938, 7: 191-230. Seligmann, E. Fiinfundzwanzig Jahre wissenschaftliche Institute im Hauptgesundheitsamt. Klin. Wschr., 1932, 11: 1720.—Seller. [On the organization, problems and functioning of the chemical department of the Central Hygiene Institute] Turk hifzissihha tecr. biyol. mecmuasi, 1938-39, 1: 26-43.—Server Kami! Tokgoz [The historical development of the Turkish Central Hygiene Insti- tute in Ankara] Ibid., 20-5.—School of Health and National Institute of Hygiene, Madrid. Bull. Health Org. League of Nat 1938, 7: 309-12.—Supfle, K. Die wissenschaftliche Pflege der Hygiene in Dresden. Deut. med. Wschr., 1936, 62: 1550-2.—Tetzlaff, F. Informe acerca del laboratorio de ana- lisis de aguas y leches del ministerio de sanidad y asistencia social. Rev. san., Caracas, 1940, 5: 377-82.—Thumrn. Die Preussische Landesanstalt fur Wasser-, Boden: und Luft- hygiene zu Berlin-Dahlem in ihren Jahresberichten, eine Zeittafel. Kleine Mitt. Verein Wasserversorg 192b, 2: 71-91.—Tomcsik, J. [Bericht iiber Tatigkeit des Kgl Ungar. Staatlichen Hygienischen Institutes im Jahre 1937] Grsz. Kozegeszs. Int. kozl., 1937, 10: No. 1, 1-411.—Tsurumi, M. Sur la creation d'un institut d'hygiene publique Koshii- Eisei-In k Tokio. Bull. Off. internat. hyg. pub., Par., 1939, 31: 064-6.—Warsaw (The) State Institute of Hygiene. Bull. Health Org. League of Nat., 1938, 7: 386-406.-Weber, F A Das Reichsgesundheitsamt; seine geschichtliche Entwicklung und organisation sowie seine Bedeutung fur die Volksgesund- heit in den 50 Jahren seines Bestehens. Khn. Wschr., 192b, 5. 1305-8.—Weisbach, W. Das Deutsche Hygiene-Museum im Dienste der Volksgesundheit. Bl. Volksgesundhpfl., 192b, 2b: ?,0-,TY,i?O8,a,v (The institutes of hygiene and the School of Public Health. Bull. Health Org. League of Nat., 1938, 7: 407-27. ---- Instruction. League of Nations. Health Organization. Report on the work of the Conferences of Direc- tors of Schools of Hygiene, held in Paris, Mav 20th to 23rd, 1930; and in Dresden July 15th to 17th, 1930; with a memorandum on the teach- ing of hygiene in various European countries, submitted to the Dresden Conference by Carl Prausnitz. 115p. 8? Geneve, 1930. Lyster, R. A. First stage hygiene; for the first stage examination of the Board of Education, containing the examination papers from 1903-5. 4. ed. 243p. 12? Lond., 1905. Macchiavello, A. La ensefianza de la higiene y medicina preventiva en Norte America. 242p. 8? Santiago de Chile, 1938. Winslow, C. E. A., & Williamson, P. B. The laws of health and how to teach them. 384p. 12? N. Y. [1926] Auscher, M. E. S. De la creacion de una escuela destinada a dar un diploma de higienista. Siglo mid., 1919, 66: 910-2.— Bard. Cours d'hygiene avril 1895. J. mid. Lyon, 1933, 14: 525-34.—Baudouin, J. A. L'enseignement de FhygiSne et la profession medicale. Union med. Canada, 1932, 61: 408-14.— Baumgartner, L. Pubhc health training, an experiment. Med. Woman J., 1938, 45: 109-11.—Belli, C. M. La scuola di sanita della R. Marina nei primi dodici anni di esistenza. Ann. med. nav., Roma, 1923, 1: 173-86.—Bernard, L. L'Ecole d'hygidne de Varsovie. Presse m6d., 1926, 34: 651.—Biegel- eisen, B. Die Stellung der Gesundheitstechnik in technischen Hochschulen und in der Praxis. Gesundh. Ingenieur, 1926, 49: 715-8.—Bruce, J. D. Michigan program for professional education in the health sciences and for public health education. Michigan Pub. Health, 1937, 25: 76-85.—Byshevskaia, M. I. [Results of the Institute of Hygiene of the First Moscow Medi- cal Institute in sanitary service education] Gig. san., Moskva, 1939, 4: No. 11, 55.—Calderon, F. Establishment and opening of the new School of Sanitation and PubUc Health. J. Philip- pine Islands M. Ass., 1927, 7: 175-7.—Calvo Fonseca, R. Las actividades de la escuela sanitaria nacional del Instituto Finlay durante los anos 1937, 1938 y 1939. San. & benef., Habana, 1939, 42: 373-7.—Coffey, E. R. Training for public health; a review and a forecast. Am. J. Pub. Health, 1940, 30: 743-8.—Collins, R. K. [The school of hygiene of the Turkish Ministry of Hygiene and social assistance] Turk hifzissihha tecr. biyol. mecmuasi, 1938-39, 107-14.—Courses of instruction for Degrees and Diplomas in Public Health. Med. Off., Lond., 1929, 42: 109.—Cromer, S. P. The role of medical schools in pubhc health education. Mississippi Doctor, 1940-41, 18: 68-73.—Davis, D. J. On the teaching of pubhc health. Med. Life, 1928, 35: 554-60.—Degrees and Diplomas in PubUc Health. Med. Off., Lond., 1929, 42: 104; passim.—Educational business; diplomas and degrees in pubUc health. Brit. M. J., 1940, 1: Suppl., 89.—Emerson, H. Purpose, content and methods of teaching pubUc health to medical students. Proc. Congr. M. Educ, 1941, 31-4. Also J. Am. M. Ass., 1941, 116: 1040-4.—Escuelas de inspectores sanitarios. In Memoria (Venezuela Min. san.) Caracas, 1937, 183-6.—Establishment of a school of hygiene and public health by the RockefeUer Foundation. Science, 1926, n. ser., 43: 889.—Fleming, A. G. Undergraduate medical training in pubUc health. Brit. M. J., 1930, 2: 633. ------ Public health and the university. Health, Toronto, 1940, 8: 13.— Fontenelle, O. Problemas do ensino e da profissao medica. Fol. med., Rio, 1936, 17: 254.—Friedlander. A. Professional education in relation to modern pubUc health. Ohio M. J., 1936, 32: 742-45.—Gaud. Organisation et programmes de l'enseignement de l'hygiene au Maroc. BuU. Off. internat. hyg. pub., Par., 1939, 31: 667-71.—Kuhn, P. Ueber die Notwendigkeit von Ordinariaten fiir Hygiene an Technischen Hochschulen. Gesundh. Ingenieur, 1927, 50: 421-5.—Ledentu. Rapport sur le fonctionnement du centre d'instruction d'Ayos (Cameroun) Ann. med. pharm. col., Par., 1935, 33: 121-5.— Loureiro, J. A. M. de. Sobre a orientacao moderna do ensino da higiene nas faculdades de medicina. Med. contemp., Lisb., 1939, 57: 43-9. Also Impr. med., Rio, 1939, 15: 150- 60.—Margulis, K. [Teaching of sanitary technique to pubUc health physicians in Kiev] Profil. med., Kharkov, 1927, 6: No. 7, 206-8.—Medical (The) student and pubUc health. Med. J. Australia, 1941, 2: 13.—Moll, A. A. Les grandes ecoles de sante du monde. Bull. Off. internat. hyg. pub., Par., 1939, 31: 656-63.—Neveu, R. L'hygiene et son enseignement dans certains pays d'Europe. Medecine, Par., 1938, 19: 961-74.— New school of public health of the University of Michigan. Science 1941, 93: 151.—Newman, G. The diploma in pubhc health. Lancet, Lond., 1936, 2: 1418.—Opening (The) of the new School of Hygiene, University of Toronto. Pub. Health HYGIENE, PUBLIC 944 HYGIENE, PUBLIC .1., Toronto, 1927. 18: 318-21.— Paz Soldan. G. E. La en- sefianza de la higiene en Estados Unidos y en Lmopa; imprcsio- nes de viaje. Reforma m6d., Lima, 1936, 22: 573-84. --- Los factores que imponen renovar la ensetiauza de la hygiene en la Facultad de ciencias m£dicas de Lima. Ibid., 1911. 27: 569-73. — Public health degrees granted in 1934 to 1939. Am. J. Pub. Health, 1935, 25: 341; passim. Public health training at Ann Arbor under the Social Sciauilr Act. Health tiff.. Wash.. 1930. 1: Xo. 5, 125-9. Keirhel, H. Die Ent- wicklung der Hygiene als Iiehrfach. Wien. klin. Wschr., 1933, 46: 738-41.— Reiter, H. Vorschliige zur Neugestaltung des Hygieneunterrichis und zur Sicherung des Nachwuchses auf dem Gebiet der Hygiene. Munch, med. Wschr., 1938, 85: 16-9.- Renseignements relatifs aux 6coles d'hygiene d'dtat. Bull. OIL internat. hyg. pub., Par., 1939, 31: 648-51.—Rohr, L. M. I'm hi graduate medical instruction in public health at the Long Island CoUege of Medicine. J. Ass. Am. M. Coll., 1940, 15: 189-91. Also repr.—Ronzani, E. Per un piu equo trattamento di carrieni degli assistenti degli Istituti d'igiene Universitari. Ann. igiene. 1930. 46: 471.—Roux. L'£cole de pratique sanitaire de \nnvcs. Hev. philanthrop., Par., 1926, 47: 361-70.—Ryerson. E. S. Cultivation of health in relation to the medical curriculum. J. Ass. Am. M. Coll., 1938, 13: 7-13.—Sanderson, E. S. State facilities as an aid in the instruction of medical students in public health. J. M. Ass. Georgia, 1941, 30: 331.—Schmidt, P. Zur Frage des Hvgiene- unterrichts. Deut. med. Wschr., 1939, 65: 1520— School of Hygiene and Public Health to be established at the University by RockefeUer Foundation. Johns Hopkins Alumni Mag., 1916, 4: 288-93.—School of PubUc Health. Univ. Hosp. BuU., Ann Arb., 1941, 7: 67.—School (The) of Hygiene and Public Health at the Johns Hopkins University. Science, 1910, 44: 303.- School (The) of Hygiene and Public Health of the Johns Hopkins University. Am. .1. Hvg., 1920, 6: Monogr. Ser., No. 0, 1-55.—School (The) of Public Healtli of the University of Michigan. Science, 1941, 94: 455.—Schools offering courses in public health, 1937-38. Healtli Off., Wash., 1939, 4: 104- Schultz, R. V. The relationslii]) of public health education to the present day practice of medicine and public health. J. M. Ass. Georgia, 1941, 30: 1 16-8.—Sestini, L. Sull'insegnamento dell'igiene in alcuni istituti di cultura navale e coloniale. Ann. med. nav.. Roma, 1920. I: 227-33.—Shep- ard. W. P. Work of the committee on professional education. Am. J. Pub. Health, 1940, 30: 1-143-6. ------ Public health degrees and certificates granted in the United States and Canada during the academic year 1940-41. Ibid., 1941, 31: 1306-11. —----Professional education. Ibid., 1942, 32: No. 3, Suppl., 45-7.- Spencer. R. R. The teaching of hygiene in medical schools. South. M. J., 1935, 28: 381-6. Also Bol. Of. san. panamer., 1936, 15: 1066-74.—Una escuela higienica. Salud & san., Bogota, 1938, 7: 0-14.—V., G. L'Ecole desante publique de l'l'niversit6 de Harvard. Presse m6d., 1920, 28: annexe, 1542.—What definite plan should be put into effect to insure to medical students knowledge of pubUc health work and an opportunity to gain practical field experience? Pub. Health Bull., Wash., 1924, No. 139, 143-51.—Whipple, G. C. L'Ecole de sante publique de l'Universit6 de Harvard et de l'Institut technologique de Massachusetts. Rev. hyg., Par., 1920, 42: 320-7.—Wilhelmi. J. Das Fortbildungs- und Anschauungswesen in der Wasser, Boden, und Lufthygiene. Atti Congr. internaz. teen, san., 1931, 2. Congr., 2: 345-52. ---- Manual. Abba, F. Manuale pratico di igiene e di vigilanza igienica. 1076p. 8? Tor., 1936. Abel, F. Grundris.s der Hygiene und Bak- teriologie. 11.-13. Aufl. 270p. 8? Berl., 1931. Allan, F. J. Aids to sanitary science, for the use of candidates for public health qualifications. 2. ed. ix, 272p. 16? Lond. [1903] Bigger, J. \Y. Handbook of hygiene, for students and practitioners of medicine. 405p. 8? Lond., 1937. Bolduan, C. F. Public health and hygiene; a students' manual. 312p. 8? Phila., 1929. ---- & Bolduan, N. W. Public health and hygiene. 2. ed. 371p. 8? Phila., 1936. Also 3. ed. 366p. 1941. Chenoweth, L. B., & Morrison, \Y. R. Community hygiene; a text book in the control of communicable diseases. 317p. 8? X. Y., 1934. Courmoxt, J., Lesieur, P. C. [et al.] Precis d'hygiene. 3. ed. 901p. 8? Par., 1925. Cours d'hygiene professe" a l'Institut d'hy- giene de la Faculte- de medecine de Paris, sous la direction de Leon Bernard et Robert Debr6 [and others] 1247p.; 81 lp. 8? Par., 1927. Daniel, Ci.. tt Daniel. A. Arts et technique* de la sante. 2v. 0S;>p.; 853p. s. Par.. 1937. Dresel, K. G. Lehrbuch der Hygiene fiir Studierende, Aerzte und Gesundheit shehorden. 499p. 8° Berl., JU2S. Egbert. S. Manual of hvgiene and sanitation. 3. ed. 473p. 8? Phila./ 1903. Also s. ed rev. 616p. 1926. Esmarch, E. von. Hygienischcs Tasehenhucli; ein Ratgeber der praktischen Hygiene fiir Medi- zinal- und Verwaltungsbeamte, Aerzte, Teeh- niker, Schulmiinner, Architekten und Bauherren 5. ed. 8? Berl., 1930. Flugge, C. Grundriss der Hvgiene; fiir Studierende und praktische Aerzte, Mcdizinal- und Verwaltungsbeamte. 9. Aufl. 863p. . 4? Hamb., P. Hartung, 1928. HYGIENISCHE und biologische Abhandlun- gen; unter Berucksichtigung der physiochemi- schen, serologischen und bakteriologischen Grenz- gebiete; Hermann Griesbach zum 70. Geburtstag, HYGIENISCHE gewidmet von Freunden, Kollegen und Schulern. 4 p. 1. 152p. 8? Giessen, A. Topelmann, 1925. HYGIENISCHE Rundschau. Berl., v.1-32, No. 6, 1891-1922. Continued as Zentralblatt fiir die gesamte Hygiene und ihre Grenzgebiete. HYGIENIST. See also Health officer. Bolduan, C. Illustrious contributors to ad- vances in public health. 14p. 4? N. Y., 1935. Walker, M. E. M. Pioneers of public health; the story of some benefactors of the human race. 270p. 8! Edinb., 1930. Balfour, A. Helpers in hygiene. J. R. Army M. Corps, 1928, 51: 30-44—Flannagan, R. K. Pioneering in health;- 1908 to 1910. Virginia M. Month., 1938, 65: 655-61 — Fotograffas de higienistas. Bol. Of. san. panamer., 1942, 21: 189.—Leathers, W. S. Pioneers in public health in the southern United States. South. M. J., 1933, 26: 305-15.—MacMaster, J. Pioneering in public health. Trained Nurse, 1933, 90: 260-6.— Modern leaders in public health. Health, Toronto, 1941, 9: 33.—Seiring, G. Lingner und sein Werk: Das Deutsche Hygiene-Museum. Zschr. Desinfekt., 1930, 22: 267-74.— Self-styled health expert found not guilty by jury. Minne- sota M., 1941, 24: 583.—Some Pan American pioneers in public health. Bol. Of. san. panamer., 1940, 19: 1234-8. HYGINUS, Caius Julius. Poeticon astrono- micon. 58 1. 8? Venezia [E. Ratdolt] Oct. 14, 1482. ----[The same] Von den zwoelf Zaichen und XXXVI Bildern des Hymels mit yedes Stern. 44 1. xm. 4? Augsb., Erhard Ratdolt, after March 8, 1491. ----[The same] De stellis [51] 1. 8? Pavia, Jacob Paucidrapensis for Octavianus Scotus, 1513. ---- [The same] Poeticon astronomicon. 56p. Paris, Guil. Morel, 1559. See also Aratus. Qaivoiieva. (3. pt) Par., 1559. HYGROMA. See also Bursa; also under names of parts affected as Kidney; Neck, etc. Zeplin, S. *Ucber die Entstehung von Rcis- korperchen in Schleimbeutelhygromen. 29p. 8? Rost., 1931. Bailey, H. Cystic hygroma. Clin. J„ Lond., 1937, 66: 242-4. Also Tr. Internat. Coll. Surgeons, 1939, 2: 31-4.— Birkenfeld, W. Ueber die Behandlung von Ganglien und Shcleimbeutelhygromen mit Clauden-Injektionen. Deut. med. Wschr., 1937, 63: 1842.—Corbett, R. S. Cystic hygroma in a Mongol. Proc. R. Soc. M., Lond., 1928-29, 22: Sect. Dis. Child., 38.—Crinelli, R. Considerazioni su un caso di igroma cronico sottodeltoideo. Riv. med., 1926, 34: 133.—Duffy, J. J. New developments in the study of hygroma. J. Iowa M. Soc, 1937, 27: 205-8.—Humphreys, F. A., & Moore, T. Studies re- lating to Brucella abortus infection; on the occurrence of the or- ganism in serous swellings or hygromata on cattle. Canad. J. Comp. M., 1941, 5: 11-20.— Joly. J. Les hygromas post-trau- matiques. Arch. mid. chir. province, 1932, 22: 214.—Jones, H. T. Cystic bursal hygromas. J. Bone Surg., 1930, 12: 45-89.— Levi, D. Cystic hygroma; case report. Proc. R. Soc. M., Lond., 1937-38, 31: 1052.—Pupovac, D. Wie sollen Hygrome und Ganglien behandelt werden? Wien. klin. Wschr., 1927, 40: 822.—Repiquet. Hygroma tuberculeux chez une vache. Bull. Soc. sc. vit. Lyon, 1898, 73-5.—Romiti, Z. L'igroma cronico emorragico pseudoneoplastico. Bull. sc. med. Bologna, 1926, 10. ser., 4: 263-9.—Simmonds, M. Ueber das Vorkommen von Zystenhygromen bei Hydrops fetalis. Zbl. allg. Path., 1923, 33: [Sonderband] 90-6.—Torraca, L. Igroma bilaterale della bursa subserrata. Riforma med., 1925, 41: 985-90.— Wulsten, J. Hygroma migrans der Bursa semimembranosa; zugleich ein Beitrag zur Differentialdiagnose des Hygroma und dor Periostitis albuminosa. Beitr. klin. Chir., 1929, 147: 559-73. HYGROMETER. See Psychromeler. HYKES, O. V. Jan Evangelista Purkyng (Purkinje) (1787-1869) his life and his work. p.464-71. portr. 8? Bruges, S. Catherine press, 1936. In Osiris, Bruges, 1936, 2: HYLANDER 947 HYMEN HYLANDER, Clarence John, 1897- See Young, Clarence Whitford, Stebbins, George L. [et al.] The human organism and the world of life. 657p. 8? N. Y., 1938. HYLEMYIA. See also Fly. Eleine, R. Die Getreideblumenfliege, Hylemyia coarctata Fall; diesjahrige Beobachtungen in Pommern. Zschr. angew. Entom., 1917, 4: 16-24. HYLESIA. Leger, M., & Mouzels, P. Dermatose prurigineuse determi- ne par des papillons saturnides du genre Hylesia. Bull. Soc. path, exot., Par., 1918, 11: 104-7. HYLIDAE. Hellmich, W. Beitrag zur Kenntnis der individuellen und geographischen Variabilitat von Hyla vilsoniana Cope. Zool. Anz., 1940, 129: 1-12.—LeitSo de Carvalho, A. Notas sobre os gfineros Corythomantis Boulenger e Aparasphenodon Miranda Ribeiro. In Papeis avuls. (S. Paulo Seer. agr. Dept. zool.) S.Paulo, 1941, 1: 101-10. HYLOTRUPES. Wichmaud, H. Hylotrupes bajulus L. in Danemark. Anz. Schadlingsk., 1931, 7: 13-6. HYMAN, Abraham, 1883- See Beer, Edwin, & Hyman, A. Diseases of the urinary tract in children. 318p. 8? N. Y., 1930. HYMAN, Albert Solomon, 1893- , & PARSONNET, Aaron Ephim. The failing heart of middle life; the myocardosis syndrome, coron- ary thrombosis, and angina pectoris; with a section on the medico-legal aspects of sudden death from heart disease, xx, 538p. 160 illust. 5 pl. 8? Phila., F. A. Davis co., 1932. See also Parsonnet, Aaron Ephim, & Hyman, A. S. Applied electrocardiography [&c] 206p. 8! N. Y., 1929. HYMAN, Joseph C. Twenty-five years of American aid to Jews overseas; a record of the Joint distribution committee [Anniversary ed.] 63p. 19Hcm. N. Y., 1939. HYMAN, Libbie Henrietta, 1888- New species of flatworms from North, Central and South America, p.419-39. 8? Wash., 1939. Forms No. 3055, v.86, Proc. U. S. Nat. Mus. —— Polyclad worms collected on the Presi- dential Cruise of 1938. 13p. 8? Wash., 1939. Forms No. 17, v.98, Smithson. Misc. Collect. ---- The invertebrates: Protozoa through Ctenophora. xii, 726p. illust. diagr. 23}£cm. N. Y., McGraw-Hill book co., 1940. ---- The polyclad flatworms of the Atlantic coast of the United States and Canada, p.449- 95. 24y2cm. Wash., 1941. Forms No. 2101, v.89, Proc. U. S. Nat. Mus. For portrait, photograph, see Collection in Library. HYMEN. See also Vagina; Virginity; Vulva. Albanese, A. L'imene (con special riguardo alle sue modi- ficazioni istologiche en rapporto ai vari penodi di sviluppo) Ricer. morf., 1933-34, 13: 143-204—Merletti, C. Contro l'opinione di Metchnikoff che l'imene rappresenti una dis- armonia della natura (frammento di lezione clinica) Clin. ostet., 1932, 34: 320-4.—Meyer, R. Zusammenfassende Bemerkungen uber die Entwicklung des distalen Endes der Vagina und des Hymens beim Menschen; ein Beitrag zur konstitutionallen Embryologie. Zbl. Gyn., 1937, 61: 284b- 65.—Nomi, T. Entwicklungsgeschichtliche Studien uber die einzelnen Organe im Sinus urogenitalis sowie in seiner Nach- barschaft beim weiblichen Fotus des Menschen; uber die Entwicklung des Hymens. Keijo J. M., 1937, 8: 151-67,^pl.— Orlowski, P. Ueber das Hymen. Arch. Frauenk., 1929, 15: 58-67.—Vilas, E. Ueber die Entwicklung des Mullerschen Hiigels und des Hymen beim Menschen. Zschr. ges. Anat., 1. Abt., 1933, 101:752-67. ----- Aplasia. Bourguy de Mendonja. Ausencia congenita do hymen; observacao pessoal. Ann. brasil. gyn., 1939, 7: 393-8. ---- Abnormity. Brindeau, A. Accouchement dans un cas de malformation de l'hymen. Gyn. obst., Par., 1936, 33: 53.—Lehmann, R. Eine abnorme Hymenform. Deut. Zschr. gerichtl. Med., 1927-28, 11: 291-4.—Olbrycht, J. Ueber Hymen bilamellatus. Bull, internat. Acad, polon. sc, 1935, cl. med., 115-33. ---- Atresia. See also Gynatresia. Aita, A. Su di un caso di atresia imenale. Clin, ostet., 1933, 35: 95-101.—Belson, M. O. Imperforate hymen. Am. J. Surg., 1937, 36: 221-5.—Bhaskara Rau, P. A case of imper- forate hymen. Ind. M. Gazv 1927, 62: 88.—Bingham, E. M., & Blevins, W. J., jr. Hematocolpos due to imperforate hymen, case. California West. M., 1938, 49: 147.—Blochas, M. [On the metbods of surgical intervention in cases of hyme- nal atresia] Medicina, Kaunas, 1940, 21: 37-9.—Bondioli, A. Un caso di ematoeolpo da atresia deH'iniene. Arte ostet., 1931, 45: 49-57.—Bowen, F. H. Imperforate hymen before the menarche with mucocolpos and mucometrium. Am. J. Obst., 1941, 42: 144.—Bowyer, T. S. Imperforate hymen with retention of menstrual contents as the cause of acute urinary retention. Bull. School M. Univ. Maryland, 1938-39, 23: 175-8.—Calvin, J. K., & Nichamin, S. J. Hematocolpos due to imperforate hymen. Am. J. Dis. Child., 1936, 51: 832-46.— Caouette, J., & Garant, O. Hematocolpos; imperforation de l'hymen. Bull. Soc. mid. h6p. Quebec, 1934, 5-7.—Carraro, A. Rottura spontanea della vagina da ematocoipo per imperviet& congenita. Clin, ostet., 1935, 37: 155-9.—Carreras, T. D. Imperforacion del himen. Vida nueva, Habana, 1928, 21: 121-4.—Correa, F. Les malformations congenitales enre- gistr^es chez les Indo-Portugais; un cas d'imperforation de l'hymen. Arq. Esc. med. cir. Nova Goa, 1929, ser. A, 689-92, pl.—Cremnitzer & L'Huillier. Deux cas d'atrgsie de l'hymen. Bull. Soc. obst. gyn. Paris, 1935, 24: 306-8.—Crossen, H. S., & Crossen, R. J. Imperforate hymen. In their Dis. Women, 9. ed., S. Louis, 1941, 742.—Dahl, P. vom. Ein Fall von Pyokol- pos infolge Atresia hymenalis. Zbl. Gyn., 1927, 51: 433-6.— Delinotte, Adle & Des Mesnards. Sur un cas d'hematocolpos avec hematometrie et hematosalpinx rivili par une retention aigue d'urine chez une jeune fille de 16 ans. Ann. anat. path., Par., 1938, 15: 675.—Doyle, J. C. Imperforate hymen; with and without hematocolpos; a review of the literature and a report of 20 cases. California West. M„ 1942, 56: 242-7.— Drosin, L. Imperforate hymen with anomalous anatomical union and position; a case report. Med. Rec, N. Y., 1935, 141: 530. ------ Treatment of imperforate hymen. Ibid., 1937, 145: 214.—Favreau & Batteur. Imperforation con- gdnitale de l'hymen; metrite purulente. Bull. Soc. obst. gyn. Paris, 1933, 22: 547.—Fleming, A. M. Imperforate hymen. J. Obst. Gyn. Brit. Empire, 1926, 33: 46-51, pl.—Fleury, C. Himen imperfurado. Arq. pollc. civ. S. Paulo, 1941, 2: 199- 203.—Gerin-Lajoie, L. Considerations sur un cas d'imper- foration de l'hymen ayant entrain^ une peritonite g6n<:ralis£e. Union med. Canada, 1934, 63: 468-72.—Gorlero Pizarro, R., & Vacarezza, R. Hematocolpo y hematometra por imper- foraci6n de himen. Sem. med., B. Air., 1937, 44: pt 2, 1232-4.— Gremnitzer & L'Huilier. Deux cas d'atresie de l'hymen. Gynecologie, Par., 1935, 34: 331.—Hammond. F. C. Imper- forate hymen, causing retention of urine. Atlantic M. J., 1925-26, 29: 690.—Hoerr, S. O. Imperforate hymen with hematocolpos. N. England J. M., 1941, 225:365-8.—Hoiloway, G. A. Imperforate hymen with hematocolpos; report of case. J. M. Ass. Georgia, 1940, 29: 535-7.—Horno Liria, R. Gina- tresia himeneal. Actual, med., Granada, 1940, 16: 115-8.— Kaarem [Case of hymen imperforatus with grave hema- tocolpos] Norsk, mag. laegevid., 1936, 97: [Forh. Kir. foren. Oslo] 40-3.—Kereszturi, C. Imperforate hymen causing hydrocolpos, hydroureter, hydronephrosis and pyuria; its occurrence in an infant. Am. J. Dis. Child., 1940, 59: 1290-7. Also repr.—Kotz, J., & Kaufman, M. S. Imperforate hymen; report of a case. Virginia M. Month., 1939, 66: 355-7.— Kouwer, B. J. [Case of hematocolpos, hematometra and hematosalpinx from imperforate hymen; operation with con- servation of Fallopian tubes; subsequent pregnancy] Ned. tschr. verlosk., 1928, 33: 69-72.—Lasala, A. J. Gran hema- tocolpos por imperforacion de himen; retenci6n aguda de orina. Sem. med., B. Air., "1926, 33: 1264.—Le Fort. Hematocolpos; imperforation de l'hymen. Bull. Soc. obst. gyn. Paris, 1933, 22: 546.—Melodia, G. Piocolpo in una bambina di 7 anni con imene imperforato. Med. inf., Roma, 1935, 6: 132-5.— Musick, J. D., & Wakeman, J. N. Imperforate hymen with hematocolpos. J. Missouri M. Ass., 1937, 34: 164.—Planas, A., Turno, A., & Figari, O. F. Un caso de hematocolpos por imperforacion de himen. Sem. med., B. Air., 1935, 42: pt 2, 1843-5.—Porro Varela, M., & Ramos, J. S. Un caso de imperforaci6n de himen. Vida nueva, Habana, 1927, 20: 280-3.—Quintana, J. A. Retenci6n completa de orina por hematocolpo (imperforaci6n dol himen) Rev. especial., B. Air 1926 1: 702.—Rocmans. Un cas d'imperforation de l'hymen. Bruxelles med., 1932-33, 13: 417.—Salazar de Sousa, C. Manifestations rares d'une imperforation de l'hymen. Arch. med. enf., 1934, 37: 721-4.—Schockaert, R. Un cas d'hematocolpos par atresie hymenale congenitale avec radio- graphic. Bruxelles med., 1937-38, 18: 8-10.—Stabile, A., & Viildez Olascoaga, A. Consideraciones clinicas sobre la gina- tresia por imperforaci6n del himen. Dia med. urug., 1940-41, HYMEN 948 HYMENOLEPIDIDAE 8: 492-5.—Tompkins, P. The treatment of imperforate hymen with hematocolpos; a review of 113 cases in the litera- ture and a report of 5 additional cases. J. Am. M. Ass., 1939, 113: 913-6.—Viannay. Imperforation de l'hymen; hemato- colpos, hematometre et double hematosalpinx; hymeneotomie, puts laparotomie necessitee par la torsion d'un hematosalpinx. Loire med., 1927, 41: 471.—Villaca, O. Sobre um caso de imperfuracflo de hymen. Rev. gyn. obst., Rio, 1933, 27: 302- 5.—Weber, F. P., & Scholtz, M. Congenital vesico-vaginal fistula with imperforate hymen; hydrops foetalis and erythro- blastosis; Polydactyly. Brit. J. Child. Dis., 1939, 36: 131-3 — Wilse. \ diliger Scheidenverschluss durch das Hymen. Zschr. Sexwiss.. 1926-27, 13: 340. ---- Cancer. Gerich, O. Primares Hymenalkarzinom. Zbl. Gyn., 1926, 50: 1372-4.—Nicholson, E., & Calatroni, C. J. Cancer primi- tivo del himen. Bol. Soc. obst. gin. B. Aires, 1934, 13: 692-8. ---- Disease. Delascio, D., & Dellivenneri, A. Molestias do hymen. Ann. paul. med. cir., 1938, 36: 485-99.—Novak, J. Bemer- kungen zu der Arbeit von Halban iiber Cirrhosis annularis subhymenalis. Zbl. Gyn., 1937, 61: 971. Examination. Biancalani, A. Note di venere forense. Gazz. internaz. med chir., 1929, 37: 543-52.—Koei Fang Suen. Appareil pour l'examen de l'hymen chez les fillettes et les femmes. Ann. med. leg., Par., 1931, 11: 154-6. ---- Forensic aspect. See also Rape. Guimaraes, A. A perfcia do defloramento; conceito da defloracao recente e da defloiucfio antiga; a perfcia no caddver; modificacoes operadas na membrana e no tubo vaginal. Rev med. Parand, 1940, 9: 333-43.— Haberda, A. Vom Hymen. Beitr. gerichtl. Med., 1935, 13: 1-4.—Modi, J. P. Signs of virginity. In his Tcxtb. Med. .lurispr., 6. ed., Bombay, 1940, 311-5.—Miiller-Hess & Schwarz. Die forensische Bedeutung des Hymens. Jahrkurs. iirztl. Fortbild., 1931, 22: H. 9, 1-13.— Obligio, J. R. Himenologfa medico-legal. Dia med., B Air 1938, 10: 207-10. ---- Injury. See also Coitus, initial; Coitus, Injury. Georgiades, J., & Eliakis, C. Sur un cas d'hemorragie mortelle due k la rupture de l'hymen au cours du premier coit. Ann. med. leg., 1938, 18: 673-9.—Rossi, D. In tema di deflora- zione senza coito. Clin, ostet., 1935, 37: 421-4.—Thierry, E. Le medecin doit-il respecter l'hymen? comment soigner les affections gynecologiques chez les vierges. Bull. Soc. obst. gyn. Paris, 1937, 26: 186-8. Also Gynecologie, 1937, 36: 671. ---- persistent and unruptured. Boynton, R. E. Pregnancy with unruptured hymen. J. Lancet, 1934, 54: 646-57.—Giebocki, S. [Case of pregnancy following superficial coitus without injury of the hymen] Nowiny lek., 1939, 51: 111.—Guimaraes, O. Um caso de gravidez precoce com himen integro nao complacente; aspeto medico-legal. Rev. gin. obst., Rio, 1941, 35: pt 2, 409-16.— Ibrahim Higazi. Hymen persisting for 2 years after marriage. J. Egypt, M. Ass., 1932, 15: 304.—Massimi, G. Integrity dell'imene. Riv. ostet. gin., 1937, 19: 290-4.—Ostergaard, E. A case of full-term pregnancy with unruptured hymen. Ind. M. Gaz., 1937, 72: 417.—Plasse, G. Malformation de l'hymen en cours de grossesse. Bull. Soc. gyn. obst. Paris, 1938, 27: 74.—Rajaofera, A. Observation d'un cas de dystocie, du k un hymen insuflisamment perfore. Bull. Soc. path, exot Par 1929, 22: 754. ---- Psychological aspect. Peixoto, A. Himenolatria. Arq. med. leg. ident., Rio, 1934, 4: 105-17.—Wile, I. S. The psychology of the hymen. J. Nerv. Ment. Dis., 1937, 85: 143-56. Tumor. Edwards, A. C, & Richardson, A. L. Rhabdomyoma of the hymen, with the report of a case in a child. Am. J. Obst 1934 27: 896-900.—Perez, M. L., & Bayona, E. Quiste epidermoideo del himen y embarazo. Bol. Soc. obst. gin. B. Aires, 1937 16- 161-6. ---- Variation of form. Binet, A. Quelques donnees sur la morphologie de l'hymen; leurs applications en gynecologie et en medecine legale' Gynecologie, Par., 1937, 36: 65-87.—Herrmann, F. Ueber eine besondere Hymenalvarietat. Zschr. ges. Anat., 1. Abt., 1928-29, 88: 784.—Tenbaum, E. Beobachtung von eigenarti- gen Hymenbildungeu. Zbl. Gyn., 1931, 55: 3307-9.—Torres Torija, J. Las formas mas frecuentes de himenes observadas durante un periodo de 3 anos en el servicio medico-legal del distrito federal. Gac. m6d. Mexico, 1928, 59: 476-9. HYMENOLEPIDIDAE. See also Helminthiasis; Hymenolepis; Taeni- idae. Mayhew, R. L. Studies on the avian species of the cestode family Hymenolepididae. 125n 8? Urbana, 111., 1925. Davies, T. I. Three closely related species of Aploparaksis Clerc, 1903. Parasitology, Lond., 1940, 32: 198-207.— Meggitt, F. J. Report on a collection of cestoda, mainly from Egypt; Cyclophyllidea; family Hymenolepididae. Ibid.. 1927 19: 420-50, 3 pl. HYMENOLEPIS. See also Hymenolepididae. Bacigalupo, J. Estudio sobre la evoluci6n biol6gica de algunos pardsitos del genero Hymenolepis (Weinland, 1858) Hymenolepsis diminuta (Rudolphi, 1819) Hymenolepis nana (Von Siebold, 1852) Hymenolepis fraterna (Stiles, 1906) Hymenolepis microstoma (Dujardin, 1845) Sem. med B Air., 1928, 35: pt 2, 1249-67.—Baer, J. G. On a new species of Hymenolepis from a monkey. J. Parasit., Urbana, 1927-28, 14: 48-50.—Chandler, A. C. The distribution of hymenolepis infections in India, with a discussion of its epidemiological significance. Ind. J. M. Res., 1927, 14: 973-9 1, 3 maps. - Hughes, R. C. A key to the species of tapeworms in Hymeno- lepis. Tr. Am. Micr. Soc, 1941, 60: 378-414.—Joyeux, C, & Foley, H. Recherches epidemiologiques sur l'HymenoIepis nana et sur l'HymenoIepis fraterna. Arch. Inst. Pasteur Algerie, 1929, 7: 31-50, 2 pl.—Kuchinsky, V. A. [Dehelminthi- zation with osarsol in hymenolepidosis] Med. parazit., Moskva 1933, 2: 151-4.—Pessoa, S., & Correa, C. Consideracoes sobre as hymenolepiases. Fol. med., Rio, 1926, 7: 37.__ Pevzner, A. I. [Epileptic attacks in Hymenolepis infestation] Trop. med. vet., Moskva, 1931, 9: 232-5.—Podyapolskaia, V., & Vassilkova, Z. [Treatment of hymenolepidosis by fractional doses of etherized extract of the male fern (Filicis maris)] Med parazit., Moskva, 1933, 2: 257-67.—Rietschel, P. E. Ueber eine neue Hymenolepis aus einem Kolibri; zugleich ein Beitrag zum Rechts-Links-Problem bei den Cestoden. Zool. Anz., 1933-34, 105: 113-23.—Romeo, N. Un caso di associazione di Hymenolepis nana e diminuta. Arch. ital. sc. med. colon., 1930, 11: 680-4.—Scholle, G. G. [Treatment of hymenolepidosis Sovet. med., 1940, 4: No. 23, 36.—Talice, R. V. Sobre hel- mintiasis por Hymenolepis en el Uruguay. Reun. Soc. argent. pat. region. (1929) 1930, 5. meet., 2: 1086-81. ---- anthocephalus. Van Gundy, C. O. Hymenolepis anthocephalus, a new tape- worm from the mole shrew, Blarina brevicauda Sav. Tr Am Micr. Soc, 1935, 54: 240-4. canoca. Jones, M. F. Aphodius granarius (Coleoptera) intermediate host for Hymenolepis carioca (Cestoda) J. Agr. Res., 1929, 38: 629-32— Luttermoser, G. W. The effect on the growth-rate of young chickens of infections of the tapeworm Hymenolepis carioca. Proc. Helminth. Soc. Washington, 1940, 7: 74-6. ---- christensoni. Macy, R. W. A key to the species of Hymenolepis found in bats and the description of a new species, H. christensoni from Myotis lucifugus. Tr. Am. Micr. Soc, 1931, 1: 344-7. ---- cuneata. Essex, H. E. A new larval cestode, probably Hymenolepis cuneata, a tapeworm of a wild duck. J. Parasit., Urbana, 1932, lo* *£*) J-—*J. ---- diminuta. Bacigalupo, J. Hymenolepis diminuta: su evoluci6n. Sem. mid., B Air. 1926, 33: pt 1, 67-9. ------ La teniasis por Hymenolepis diminuta en el hombre. Rev. Soc. med. int., k "> 19?6' 2tV 206-1f------Sur quelques anomalies observes chez Hymenolepis diminuta (Rudolph) C. rend. Soc biol. 1928, 99: 1417. ------ Un nuevo hasped inter- mediary del Hymenolepis diminuta (Rudolphi 1819) el Ulo- sonia parvicornia Fairmaire 1892. Sem. med B Air 1929 36: P^r1, 1339; ~,--- & Aguirre Pequena, E. Un n'ouvenu cas d Hymenolepis diminuta chez I'homme, au Mexique Hull boc path, exot., Par., 1938, 31: 502-4.—Belova, O. A [Case of Hymenolepis diminuta (Rud., 1819) in a childl Med parazit. Moskva, 1936, 5: 813.—Chandler, A. C. The effects ot number and age of worms on development of primary and secondary infections with Hymenolepis diminuta in rats and an investigation into the true nature of premunition in tape- worm infections. Am. J. Hyg., 1939, 29: 105-14. ——— Failure of artificial immunization to influence Hymenolepis diminuta infections in rats. Ibid., 1940, 31: Sect. D, 17-22 — Clark, E. B. Human infestation with the rat tapeworm (Hyme- nolepis diminuta) J. Am. M. Ass.; 1930, 95: 1342-Gundrum, *. *., & Synder JR. Hymenolepis diminuta; report of a case. California West. M., 1927, 25: 350— Kamalov, N. Beobach- HYMENOLEPIS 949 HYMENOLEPIS tungen an Hymenolepis diminuta (Rudolphi, 1819) Arch Schiffs Tropenhyg., 1931, 35: 606-11.—Keller, A. E. Eight cases of human infestation with the rat tapeworm (Hymeno- lepis diminuta) J. Parasit., Urbana, 1931, 18: 108-10.— Kobori, K. Beitrage zur Kenntnis von Hymenolepis diminuta; ist der Zwischenwirt fiir die Entwicklung von Hymenolepis diminuta erforderlich? zugleich Untersuchungen uber die Re- sistenz der Eier. Tr. Japan. Path. Soc, 1924, 14: 184.—Liddo, S. Hymenolepis diminuta nella provincia di Bari. Pathologica, Genova, 1938, 30: 436.—Luney, F. W. Hymenolepis diminuta (rat tapeworm) in man; with the report of a case. Canad. M. Ass. J., 1934, 30: 385.—Momma, K. On a case of Hymenolepis diminuta Rud., 1819. Ann. M. Parasit., Liverp., 1928-29, 22: 1-3.—Palais, M. Resistance des rats k l'infestation d'Hymeno- lepis diminuta (Rud.) C. rend. Soc. biol., 1934, 117: 1016.— Roman, E. Hotes intermediates nouveaux d'Hymenolepis diminuta (Cestodes; hymenoiepididesO Ibid., 1937, 126: 26- 8.—Shchastny, N. M. [Finding of Hymenolepis diminuta in man] Trop. med. vet., Moskva, 1930, 8: 50.—Simoes, B. C. Sobre un caso de Hymenolepis diminuta. Tribuna med., Rio, 1925, 31: 81.—Versiani, W., & Renault, L. Parasitismo humano pela Hymenolepis diminuta, Rudolphi, 1819. Brazil med., 1939, 53: 453-6.—Zeitlenok, N. A., & Kolosov, N. I. [Observations on a case of infestation in man with Hymenolepis diminuta] Med. parazit., Moskva, 1936, 5: 811. ---- erinacei. Joyeux, C. Recherches sur le cycle evolutif d'Hymenolepis erinacei (Gmelin, 1789) Ann. parasit., Par., 1926, 5: 20-6. ---- exigua. Alicata, J. E., & Chang, E. The life history of Hymenolepis exigua, a cestode of poultry in Hawaii. J. Parasit., Lancaster, 1939, 25: 121-7. ---- fraterna. Bacigalupo, J. Hymenolepis fraterna (Stiles, 1906) Sem. med., B. Air., 1928, 35: pt 2, 1428-44. ------■ Evolution de l'HymenoIepis fraterna Stiles, chez Pulex irritans L., Xenopsylla cheopis Rothschild et Ctenocephalus canis Curtis. Ann. parasit., Par., 1931, 9: 339-43. ------ El Ctenocephallus canis, Curtis, en la evolucion de la Hymenolepis fraterna, Stiles. Sem. med., B. Air., 1931, 38: pt 1, 878-80. Hymenolepis fraterna (Stiles 1906) C. rend. Congr. internat. med. trop. hyg., 1932, 4. Congr., 55-69.—Hunninen, A. V. Studies on the life history and host-parasite relations of Hyme- nolepis fraterna (H. nana, var. fraterna, Stiles) in white mice. Am. J. Hyg., 1935, 22: 414-43. ------ An experimental study of internal autoinfection with Hymenolepis fraterna in white mice. J. Parasit., Urbana, 1936, 22: 84-7.—Joyeux, C, & Baer, J. G. Recherches sur le cvcle evolutif d'Hymenolepsis fraterna Stiles. C. rend. Soc. biol., 1928, 99: 1317.—Kiri- bayashi, S. Studies on the growth of Hymenolepis nana, with special reference to the possibility of differentiation of H. nana var. fraterna (Stiles) Taiwan igakkai zasshi, 1933, 32: 117.— Shorb, D. A. Host-parasite relations of Hymenolepis fraterna in the rat and the mouse. Am. J. Hyg., 1933, 18: 74-113. ---- intermedia. Bacigalupo, J. Hymenolepis intermedius (nueva especie) su evolucion. Sem. med., B. Air., 1927, 34: pt 1, 229. ---- mastigopraedita. Polk, S. J. Hymenolepis mastigopraedita, a new cestode from a pintail duck. J. Parasit., Lancaster, 1942, 28: 141-5, incl. pl. ---- microps. Clapham, P. A. On the presence of hookson the rostellum of Hymenolepis microps. 21-4. J. Helminth., S. Albans, 1939, 17: ---- microstoma. Bacigalupo, J. ' Hymenolepis microstoma (Dujardin) chez Mus musculus (L.) C. rend. Soc. biol., 1928, 99: 1402 — Joyeux, C, & Koboziev, N. I. Recherches sur 1 Hymenolepis microstoma (Dujardin, 1845) Ibid., 1927, 96: 12-4. Also Ann. parasit., Par., 1928, 6: 59-79—Larrousse, F. Hotes intermediaires nouveaux d'un cestode de la souris: Hymeno- lepis microstoma (Dujardin, 1845) C. rend. Soc. biol., 1929, 100: 855-7. ---- nana. Calder6n, R. *Ueber einen Fall von Hymeno- lepis nana-Parasitismus und iiber die derzeitige Kenntnis dieses Parasiten [Berlin] 63p. 8. Charlottenb., 1928. Bacigalupo, J. L'evolution de l'HymenoIepis nana. G. rend. Soc. biol., 1928, 99: 239. Also Sem. med., B. Air., 1928, 39: pt 1 200. ------ Hymenolepis nana (Von biebold, 1°5J) Ibid., pt 2, 1349-66.—Badalian, A. L. [Localization of the cystercoids of Hymenolepis nana in the intestinal tract of the white mouse] Med. parazit., Moskva, 1938 7: 580-3 — Beukema, W. [Case of infection with Hymenolepis nana] Geneesk. tschr. Ned. Indie, 1941, 81: 2014-20.—Bruni, E. ioo\e S»S1 ,1,1ot^nia nana negli Abruzzi. Boll. Soc. eustach., 1925, 23: 123-7. —---- La tenia nana; i primi sette casi d infestazione negli Abruzzi. Ann. med. nav., Roma, 192,7 a -I" Cordaba' s- Un caso de accesos epileptiformes producidos por la H. nana y un caso de vomitos tenaces do origen vermicular. Vargas, Caracas, 1917, 8: 232-8—De Riyas, D. Hymenolepis (Taenia) nana. In Cyclop. Med. (Piersol-Bortz) Phila., 1939, 11: 286.—Euziere, J., & Harant, "• j Accidents nerveux imputables k Hymenolepis nana. Medecine, Par., 1939, 20: 133-8.—Figueira Martins, C. Ovo- metna da Hymenolepis nana. Arch. Inst. Benjamin Baptista, Kio, 1936, 2: 85-94.—Gelonesi, G. Entente a Hymenolepis nana in adulto di 37 anni. Gazz. osp., 1931, 52: 1009-12 — Gordadze, G. N. [Symptomatology of dwarf hymenolepidosisl Med. parazit., Moskva, 1940, 9: 450.—Headlee, W. H. Ob- servations on the duration of an infection of Hymenolepis nana in man. J. Parasit., Lancaster, 1941, 27: No. 6, Suppl., 23.— Hearin, J. T. Studies on the acquired immunitv to the dwarf tapeworm, Hymenolepis nana var. fraterna, in the mouse host. Am. J Hyg., 1941, 33: Sect. D, 71-87.— Kornfeld, M. Beitrag zur Kenntnis der Darmveranderungen durch Hymenolepis (Taenia) nana. Virchows Arch., 1925,258: 512-28.—Krajewski F. [Taenia nana] Lek. wojsk., 1935, 25: 41-44.—Larsh, J. E.. jr. Demonstration of naturally acquired, passive immunity to Hymenolepis nana var. fraterna. J. Parasit., Lancaster, 1941, 27: No. 6, Suppl., 37.—Lorincz, F. [Cases of Hymenolepis nana in man, in Hungary] Orv. hetil., 1929, 73: 346-51 — Long, H. F. The dwarf tapeworm (Hymenolepsis nana) a newly recognized parasite; report of a case. Charlotte M. J., 1905, 27: 39-42.—Nishio, K. Clinical studies on the disease caused by Hymenolepis nana (von Siebold) Jap. J. Exp. M., 1939, 17: 319-31, pl.—Noronha, A. J. A case of Hymenolepis nana infection. J. Trop. M. Hyg., Lond., 1934, 37: 325 — Obrastzov, S. N. [Spreading of Taenia nana in Soviet Russia] Vrach. gaz., 1927, 31: 493-5.—Ogura, K. Studies on the Hymenolepis nana in Korea. J. Chosen M. Ass., 1936, 26: 35.—Oquinena, F. Etudes sur l'HymenoIepis nana en Espagne. Ann. parasit., Par., 1929, 7: 469-76.—Ossinovsky, N. I. [Taenia nana in children] Pediatria, Moskva, 1929, 13: 353- 5.—Otto, G. F. Human infestation with the dwarf tapeworm [Hymenolepis nana) in the southern United States. Am. J. Hyg., 1936, 23: 25-32.—Palomo Erosa, E. Seis casos de Hymenolepis nana en Yucat&n. Rev. med. Yucatan, 1938-40, 20: 193-6.—Paredes G., J. E. Algunas consideraciones sobre un caso de Hymenolepis nana. Bol. Hosp. S. Juan, Quito, 1928, 3: No. 30, 7-12, pl.—Parodi. S. E. Sobre un nuevo caso de helmintiasis producido por la Hymenolepsis nana. Prensa med. argent., 1915-16, 2: 405. ----— Doce casos de hel- mintiasis por Hymenolepis nana. Ibid., 1917-18, 4: 294-7.— Pimentel Imbert, M. F. La Hymenolepis nana en nuestra Republica. An. Univ. Santo Domingo, 1941, 5: 54-7.— Rodriguez Lopez-Neyra, C, & Torres Lopez, A. J. El Hymeno- lepis nana como parasito intestinal humano en Espafia. Med. ibera, 1928, 22: pt 2, 194-8.—Roman F. Sur la localisation, chez le tenebrion, du cysticercoide de l'HymenoIepis nain des murides. C. rend. Soc. biol., 1938, 129: 551.------Sur l'infestation des rongeurs par i'Hymenolepis nana de I'homme. Ann. parasit., Par., 1939, 17: 12-6.—Scheltema, M. W. [Case of Taenia nana diarrhea] Geneesk. gids, 1927, 5: 1208.— Scholle, G. G. [Hymenolepidosis nana in children] Pediatria, Moskva, 1940, No. 2, 3-8.—Schnell, W. Ein Fall von Massen- infektion mit Taenia nana als Sektionsbefund. Zbl. Bakt., 1. Abt., 1918, 82: Orig., 304-6.—Scrimaglio, E. F. Hymenolepis nana:- parasitologia y nueva casos cllnicos; rol patdgeno; profilaxis; tratamiento. Rev. med. Rosario, 1927, 17: 401-9, 2 pl.—Shneerson, A. A. [Hymenolepis nana infection among children in Odessa] Odess. med. J., 1930, 5: 53-64.—Tsuchiya, H., & Rohlfing, E. H. Hymenolepis nana; report of additional cases and an experimental transmission from man to rats. Am. J. Dis. Child., 1932, 43: 865-72. Also repr.—Wang, Lo-Shan. Human infection of Hymenolepis nana in North China; an analysis of 171 cases. Chin. M. J., 1938, 54: 141-50. ---- pittalugai. Lopez-Neyra, C. R. Hymenolepis pittalugai n. sp. et ses rapports avec les espaces similaires (H. macracanthos) Ann. parasit., Par., 1932, 10: 248-56. sinensis. Oldham, J. N. On Hymenolepis sinensis n. sp.; a new cestode from the grey sand-hamster (Cricetulus griseus) J. Helminth., Lond., 1929, 7: 235-46. ---- Weinl. Davies, T. I. Four species of Hymenolepsis Weinl. parasitio in the oystercatcher, Haematopus ostralegus Linn. Para- sitology, Lond., 1939, 31: 401-12. HYMENOMYCETES. Bauch, R. Untersuchungen iiber zweisporige Hymeno- myceten; Kerndegeneration bei einigen Clavaria-Arten. Arch. Protistenk., 1927, 58: 285-99, 2 pl.—Buhr, H. Unter- suchungen iiber zweisporige Hymenomyceten. Ibid., 1932, HYMENOMYCETES 950 HYMENOPTERA 77: 125-51, pl.—Buller, A. H. R. The biological significance of conjugate nuclei in Coprinus lagopus and other Hymeno- mycetes. Nature, Lond., 1930, 126: 086-9. Fukunaga, S. Ueber die pathologische Bedeutung der Schimmelpilze, be- sonders deren Beziehung zu der Gleichgcwiehtsstorung des Korpers. Tr. Jap. Path. Soc, 1926, 16: 120.—Lutz, L. Sur les ferments solubles secretes par les champignons hymeno- mycetes; actions oxydantes. C. rend. Acad, sc, 1926, 183: 95-7. ------ Sur les ferments solubles secretes par les champignons hymenomycetes: actions antioxyg&ies simples. Ibid., 918. ------ Sur les ferments solubles secretes par le.': champignons hymenomycetes; actions antioxygdnes superposees aux actions reductrices. Ibid., 1927, 184: 173. ——— Sur les ferments solubles secretes par les champignons hymeno- mycetes; la degradation de la mature ligneuse. Ibid., 1930, 190: 1455. ------ Sur les ferments hydrolysants secretes par les champignons hymenomycetes; degradation des elements constituants de la membrane cellulaire. Bull. Soc. chim. biol., Par., 1931, 13: 430-57. ------ Sur les ferments solubles secretes par les champignons hymenomycetes; comparaison du pouvoir antioxygene du tanin et des constituants phenoliques des essences. C. rend. Acad, sc, 1931, 193: 608. ------ Les constituants alcooliques des essences et la fonction anti- oxygene. Ibid., 1220. ------ Sur les ferments solubles secretes par les champignons hymenomycetes. Ibid., 1934, 199: 893-6. ------ Sur les ferments solubles secretes par les champignons hymenomycetes; action conjuguees antioxygene. Ibid., 1939, 208: 392-4.—Quintanilha, A. Troisieme contribu- tion k l'etude genetique du phenomene de Buller. C. rend. Soc. biol., 1938, 129: 730-4.—Vandendries, R. La conduite sexuelle des hymenomycetes interpretee par les theories dc Hartmann concernant la bisexualite et la relativite sexuelle. Bull. Acad. Belgique, cl. sc, 1930, 5. ser., 16: 1213-34. HYMENOPTERA. See also Bee; Chalcididae; Cynipidae, &c. Rey, M. *Effets des piqures d'hymenopteres aculeates. 124p. 8? Lyon, 1935. Snodgrass, R. E. The male genitalia of Hymenoptera. 86p. 33 pl. 24}£cm. Wash., 1941. Araujo, R. L. Contribuicao para o conhecimento do genero Editha Parker; Hymenoptera, Bombicidae. Bol. biol., S. Paulo, 1939, 4: 505-11.—Arias, F., & Vidal Giiemes, A. Choc anafildctico por picadura de himen6ptero. Bol. Inst. clfn. quir., B. Air., 1928, 4: 705.—Banks, N. Notes on the United States species of Tachytes (Hymenoptera, Larridae) Bull. Mus. Comp. Zool. Harvard, 1942, 89: 395-436, pl.—Bouvier, G. Quelques hymenopteres ennemis des glossines. Ann. parasit., Par., 1936, 14: 330.—Clark, A. H. The butterflies of Virginia. Pub. Smithson. Inst., 1937, No. 3407, 47-52; 1938, No. 3480, 77-80. Also Explor. Smithson. Inst. (1938) 1939, 65-8. ------ Notes on some north and middle American Danaid butterflies. Proc. U. S. Nat. Mus., 1941, 90: 531-42.— Clausen, C. P. The oviposition habits of the Eucharidae, Hymenoptera. J. Washington Acad. Sc, 1940, 30: 504-16.— Costa Lima, A. da. Pseudotelenomus pachycoris (N. G., N. Sp.), parasite des oeufs de Pachycoris torridus (Scop.) C. rend. Soc. biol., 1928, 99: 880-3.—Courboules, P., & Mandillon, G. A. L. Accidents graves survenus apres une piqure d'hymeno- ptere. Arch. med. pharm. mil., 1934, 100: 297-303.—Dow, R. A new Stizus from Utah, with notes on the other North Ameri- can species, Hym., Sphecidae. Psyche J. Entom., 1941, 48: 171-81.—Eidmann, H. Eizahl und Eireifung einiger forstlich wichtiger Schmetterlinge; vorlaufige Mitteilung. Zschr. angew. Entom., 1927-28, 13: 549-54.—Faure, J. C. Sur l'origine adaptative de la tariere des hymenopteres parasites. C. rend. Soc. biol., 1926, 94: 1162.—Ferriere, C. New species of Euplectrini, Hym., Chalcidoidea, from Europe, Africa and Asia. Bull. Entom. Res., Lond., 1941, 32: 17-48.—Flanders, S. E. Sex differentiation in the polyembryonic proclivity of the Hymenoptera. J. Econ. Entom., 1942, 35: 108.— Frohne, W. C. Semiaquatic Hymenoptera in North Michigan lakes. Tr. Am. Micr. Soc, 1939, 58: 228-40.—Gerould, J. H. Butterflies [methods of rearing] In Cult. Meth. Invertebr. (Galtsoff, P. S., et al.) Ithaca, 1937, 365-9.—Giersberg, H. Die Farbung der Schmetterlinge. Zschr. vergl. Physiol., 1929, 9: 523-52.—Gille, M. Piqures d'hymenopteres. Rev. prat. biol., Par,, 1935, 28: 105-12.—Gotze, G. Untersuchungen an Hymenopteren; iiber das Vorkommen und die Bedeutung der Stirnaugen. Zool. Jahrb., Abt. allg. Zool., 1927, 44: 211-68 — Grandi, G. Specific ed eterogeneiti delle vittime degli imenotteri predatori, specializzazione di comportamento delle feminine nidificanti e necessity dietetiche delle loro larve. Mem. Accad. sc. Bologna, 1929-30, 8. ser., 7: 75-80.—Hachlow, V. Zur Entwicklungsmechanik der Schmetterlinge. Arch. Entwmech., 1931-32, 125: 26-49.—Heller, J. Sauerstoff- verbrauch der Schmetterlingspuppen in Abhangigkeit von der Temperatur. Zschr. vergl. Physiol., 1929-30, 11: 448-60 — Maa, Tsing-Chao. Notes on some Philippine Xylocopa (Hymenoptera; Xylocopidae) Philippine J. Sc, 1939, 69: 423-32.—Mangabeira, O., fil. Contribuicao ao conhecimento dos insectos que vivem em figos do Brasil; uma nova especie de Eupistrina Saunders. Mem. Inst. Oswaldo Cruz, 1937, 32: 461-8, 6 pl.—Michener, C. D. A synopsis of the genus Acera- taspis; Hymenoptera, Ichneumonidae. Psyche J. Entom., 1940, 47: 121-4.—Mickel, ('. E. Mutillidae of the Philippine Islands. Philippine .1. Sc , 1934, 54: 91-218, pl.—Miles, H. W. The fruit-infesting saw flies of Britain. Rep. Brit. Ass. Advance. Sc, 1937, 107: 309 —Mitchell, R. T. The alimentary tract of Vespula maculilKins Buy.; IIvmenoptcra; Vespidae. Ohio J. Sc, 1941, 41: 29-38, incl. 3 pl. Molitor, A. Experimentelle Beitrage zur Etholojjie der Hymenopteren. Biol. Zbl., 1936, 56: 518-32. ------ Zur vergleichenden Psychobiologie der akuleaten Hymenopteren auf experimenteller Grundlage (mit besonderer Benicksiehtigung der Sphegiden) Biol, gen., Wien, 1937, 13: 294-333. Miiller. K. IIymcnoptercn-ParatypliUB7 die Darmbakterien der Nahrungsmittel besuchenden Bienen, Wespen und Hummeln. Zbl. Bakt., 1. Abt., 1925-20, 97: 214-8.-—Nixon, G. E. J. New species of Braconidae (Hymeno- ptera) Bui. Entom. Res., Lond., 1939, 30: 119-28. ------ New African and Oriental species of Microdus, Nees, from known hosts; Hymenoptera, Braconidae. Ibid., 1941, 32: 111-8.—Osorio, J. M. Un nuevo hospedero en Cuba de Euplectrus platyhypenae, Chalcidae; Elachertidae. Rev. med. trop. parasit., Habana, 1941, 7: 15.—Paillot. A. Modi- fications cytologiques et organiques engendrees chez les puce- rons par les hymenopteres parasites. C. rend. Acad, sc, 1934, 199: 1450-2.-—Parkin, E. A. Symbiosis in larval Siricidae (Hymenoptera) Nature, Lond., 1941, 147: 329.—Puzanowa- Malyschewa, E. W. Beitrag zur Biologie einer neuen Schlupf- wespe: Syntomaspis eurytornae nov. spec. (Hym., Torymidae) Zschr. wiss. Insektb., 1937, 27: 131-45.—Reuss. T. Neues iiber den Sexualkult bei Schmetterlingen. Umschau, 1926, 30: 644-6.—Rimsky-Korsakow, M. Methoden zur Untersuchung von Wasserhymenoptcren. In Handb. biol. Arbeitsmeth. (Abderhalden, E.) Berl., 1938, 9, T. 7, Bd 3, 227-58.—Roch. Les piqflres d'hymenopteres au point de vue clinique et thera- peutique. Rev. med. Suisse rom., 1928, 48: 913-50.—Rohwer, S. A. Two bethylid parasites of the pink boll worm (Hymeno- ptera, Bethyliidae) Insecutor, Wash., 1917, 5: 1-5.—Ross, H. H. A generic classification of the nearctic sawflies (Hymeno- ptera, Symphyta) Illinois Biol. Monogr., 1937, 15: No. 2, 7-173.—Saint-Hilaire, C, & Wassiljewa, N. Die Variabilitat des Fliigelzeichnungsmusters bei dem Schmetterling Thais polyxena. Biol. Zbl., 1929, 49: 392-408.—Schmieder, R. G, Observations on the fat-body in Hymenoptera. J. Morph., 1928, 45: 121-73, 6 pl.—Schubel. Polyembryony in parasitic Hymenoptera. Ciba Symposia, 1941-42, 3: 1024.—Semichon, L. Modification precoces des reserves, avant la metamorphose chez un hymenoptere: Dasypoda plumipes Panzer. C. rend. Soc biol., 1931, 108: 1140.—Sprengel, L. Die Pflaumensage- wespen, Hoplocampa minuta Christ, und Hoplocampa flava L. (Hym. Tenthredo) Zschr. angew. Entom., 1930, 16: 1-86.— Stelfox, A. W. Descriptions of 5 new species of Alysiidae, Hymenoptera, and notes on some others. Proc. R. Irish Acad., 1941, 47: sect. B, 1-16. ------ A new species of Blacus (Hymenoptera: Braconidae) with some notes on other species of the genus. Ibid., 121-4. ------ A list of the Irish species of Toxares and Ephedrus, Hymenoptera, Aphidiidae, with descriptions of these, which include 3 species new to science. Ibid., 125-42.—Varley, G. C. On the search for hosts and the egg distribution of some chalcid parasites of the knapweed gall-fly. Parasitology, Lond., 1941, 33: 47-66.—Vilar del Valle, J. L. Muerte por picadura de himen6ptero. Arch. urug. med., 1934, 5: 299-302.—Warnecke, O. Uebersicht uber die zum Jahre 1928 auf den nordfriesischen Inseln beobachteten Groszschmetterlinge. Schr. Naturwiss. Verein. Schl. Holstein, 1927-28, 18: 263-92.—Weber, H. Vergleichend- funktionsanatomische Untersuchungen an atypischen Beiss- mandibeln von Insekten mit besonderer Berucksichtigung dor Phyllotoma-Larve (Hymenoptera; Tenthredinidae) Biol. Zbl., 1939, 59: 541-66.—Wilkinson, D. S. New parasitic Hymenoptera and notes on other species. Bull. Entom. Res., Lond., 1929-30, 20: 103-14.—YaeumatsH, K. Additions to the hymenopterous fauna of the Ishigaki Island. Annot. zool. jap., 1933, 14: 259-68, pl.------Further notes on the hymenopterous fauna of the Yaeyama group. Ibid., 1935, 15: 33-45. HYNEK, Kristian, 1879-1939. Brdlik, J. [Personal reminiscences] Cas. 16k. Cesk., 1939, 78: 898, portr. HYNEK, R. W. Konnersreuth; a medical and psychological study of the case of Teresa Neu- mann; translated and adapted by Lancelot C. Sheppard. 3 p. 1. 150p. pl. 8? Lond., B. Oates & Washbourne, 1932. ---- La passione di Cristo studiata dalla scienza medica moderna. 2. ed. 3 p. 1. 142p. pl. 20cm. Milano, Vita e Pensiero, 1938. HYNOBIUS. Oyama, Z. Demonstration der Hynobius-Arten aus Kyusyu. Jap. J. M. Sc, Anat., 1941, 9: Proc, 30. HYNSON, Westcott & Dunning, inc. The present status of mercurochrome. 13 1. 8? Bait., The Firm, 1932. Mimeographed. HYOID 951 HYOID HYOID. See also Deglutition: Neck;Pharynx;Tongue. See also names of muscles as Omohyoid muscle, &c. Adachi, S., & Ito, M. Anatomische und vergleichend- anatomische Untersuchungen der Erwachsenen und der Embryonen von Manis aurita (Hodgson) Taiwan igakkai zassi, 1939, 38: 1570; 1580.—Blume, W. Das Hyoid von Hyla peronii und von Bombina maxima. Morph. Jahrb., 1932 71- 171-80.—De Beer, G. R. On the skeleton of the hyoid arch in rays and skates. Q. J. Micr. Sc, Lond., 1932, 75: 307-20, 3 pl.—Edgeworth, F. H. On the development of the hyoid bar and rays in Plagiostomi. J. Anat., Lond., 1931, 66: 104-13.— Fuchs, H. Ueber das Os parahyoideum der Unken (Bombina- tor) (ein rudimentares Organ) nebst einigen Bemerkungen uber das Zungenbein dieser Tiere tiberhaupt und iiber rudimentare Organe. Morph. Jahrb., 1937, 79: 331-57.—Garraud, R., & Debeyre, J. Appareil hyoidien et espaces peri-pharyngiens Echo med. nord. 1931, 35: 205-14.—Harburger, A. L'im- portance clinique de I'appareil hyoidien complet. Vie med 1926, 7: 487-90.—Kelemen, G. Vergleichend-anatomische Rontgenbeobachtungen am Zungenbeinapparate. Arch Ohr &c Heilk., 1929, 122: 161-9.—Miyashita, K. Ueber die Grosse des Zungenbeins der Chinesen. J. Orient. M., Dairen, 1935, 22: 6.—Monteiro, H. Sur l'origine de l'os hyoide. C. rend. Soc biol., 1926, 95: 305-7.—Mutel & Rousseaux. Ossification de I'appareil hyoidien. Ann. anat. path., Par., 1926, 3: 651-3.— R6my-Neris. Sur les rapports du tractus thyreoglosse avec l'os hyoide sur l'embryon humain. C. rend. Soc. biol., 1928, 99: 1797.—Reverdin, L. Les os hyoidiens de la faune lacustre neolithique. Rev. anthrop., Par., 1927, 37: 131-7.—Richter, H. Das Zungenbein und seine Muskulatur bei den Lacertilia vera Jena. Zschr. Naturwiss., 1932-33, 66: 395-480.—Sprague, J. M. A study of the hyoid apparatus of the Cricetinae. J. Mammal., 1941, 22: 296-310.—Stadtmiiller, F. Das Os parahyoideum (Fuchs) bei Liopelma hochstetteri und Rhinophrynus dorsalis mit Bemerkungen uber den gesamten Zungenbein-Kehlkopf- Apparat dieser seltenen Froschlurche. Morph. Jahrb., 1936, 78: 1-35.—Stolyhwo, E. Anthropologische Charakteristik des Os hyoideum. Mitt. Anthrop. Ges. Wien, 1927, 57: 62.— Vazquez Herrera, C, & Macias Alcantara, M. Contribuci6n al estudio de la inervaci6n de ciertos musculos de la region infrahioidea. Arq. anat., Lisb., 1937, 18: 91-100.—Wilson, H. C. What is the hyoid apparatus? Irish J. M. Sc, 1934, ser. 6, 535, 2 pl. ---- Abnormity and disease. Barth, H. Klinische und rontgenologische Betrachtungen iiber anormale Verknocherungsvorglinge im menschlichen Zungenbeinapparat. Zschr. Hals &c Heilk., 1929, 23: 9-17.— Demllee, P., & Moreau, F. Sur un cas d'ossification de I'appareil hyoidien chez I'homme. J. med. Bordeaux, 1935, 112: 334.—Frasin, I. Appareil hyoide ossifie chez I'hom- me. Ann. anat. path., Par., 1937, 14: 443-6.—Goldstern, S. Ueber eine rheumatoide Erkrankung in der Zungenbeinge- gend. Wien. klin. Wschr., 1936, 49: 500.—Harburger, A. Etude anatomique, clinique et radiologique de I'appareil hyoidien normal et anormal chez l'homme; 13 observations inedites. Arch, internat. laryng., Par., 1925, 31: 933; 1407.— Hiinermann, T. Ueber Osteomyelitis des Zungenbeins. Zschr. Laryng., 1930-31, 20: 319-22.—Knox, R. An unusual develop- ment of the hyoid apparatus. Acta radiol., Stockh., 1926, 7: 69-72, 2 pl.—Levicek, J. [Ossification of the hyoid apparatus in man and unilateral congenital abnormality of the thyreoid cartilage] Cas. lek. desk., 1931, 70: 1466-72.—Mangabeira- Albernaz, P. Les anomalies de I'appareil hyoidien et leur importance en oto-rhino-laryngologie. Ann. otolar., Par., 1931, 1044-58. ------ Nouvelles considerations sur I'appareil hyoidien anormal. Rev. laryng., Bord., 1938, 59: 187-95. —----& de Oliveira Lima, O. As anomalias do apparelho hyoideo e sua importancia em oto-rhino-laryngologia. Brasil med., 1930, 44: 1331-7.—Nelson, L. A. Hyoid bursitis. Texas J. M., 1940-41, 36: 435-8.—Olivier, Theodoresco & Moros. Deux nouveaux cas d'ossification de I'appareil hyoidien chez I'homme. Ann. anat. path., Par., 1938, 15: 423-6.—Ponthus, Henri & Notter. Radiographic d'une double anomalie des grandes cornes de l'os hyoide. Ann. otolar., Par., 1938, 646- 8.—Puchowski, B. Un cas d'anomalie de I'appareil hyoidien. Acta otolar., Stockh., 1932-33, 18: 447-59.—Viela, A. Con- tribution k l'etude des anomalies de I'appareil hyoidien. Bull. Soc. anthrop. Paris, 1925, 7. ser., 6: 89-97. ---- Fracture. Baudin, & Larieux. Fracture de l'hyoide chez le cheval. Rev. vet., Toulouse, 1923, 75: 37.—Forbes, S. B. Fracture ol the greater cornu of the hyoid bone; perforation of the pharynx; case report. J. Florida M. Ass., 1931, 17: 585.—Harrell, V. Fracture of hyoid bone; case report. Grace Hosp. Bull., Detr., 1929, 13: 11.—Ninger [Fracture of the hyoid bone] Cas. 16k. Cesk., 1930, 69: 103; 1931, 70: 1480, 2 pl.—Slack, H. R., jr Fractures of hyoid bone, thyroid and cricoid cartilages and trachea. In Textb. Surg. (Christopher, F.) 3. ed., Phila., 1942, 617 —Wein, S. Interessanter Fall einer Zungenbemfraktur. Verh. ungaj, arztl. Ges., 1929, 1: 106. ---- Surgery. Husni, S. De l'extirpation de l'os hyoide comme temps compiementaire de I'ablation des kystes mucoldes thyro- hyoidiens. J. chir., Par., 1932, 40: 358.—Semih Sumerman [On extensive excision of the hyoid bone in radical treatment of thyroglossal cysts] Bull. Soc turque med., 1939, 5: 265-71. ---- Tumor. Schlachetzki, H. S. *Das Zungenbein und seine Erkrankungen unter besonderer Beruck- sichtigung eines Falles von Zungenbeinsarkom. 19p. 8? Bresl., 1925. Martinez, R. Nota sobre un tridermoma. Med. ibera, 1934, 28: pt 1, 628. HYON, Monique Marie [nee Jomier] 1908- *Les nephrites chroniques de l'enfant. 193p. 8? Par., L. Arnette, 1938. HYOPHARYNGEUS muscle. See under Pharynx. HYOSCINE. See Scopolamine. HYOSCYAMINE. See also Belladonna; Datura; Hyoscyamus; also Atropine. Simonowitsch, R. *Ueber Hyoscyamin und dessen Bedeutung fiir die Augenheilkunde [Bern] 44p. 8? Wiesbaden, 1874. Wallenhorst, F. A. *Ueber die Verschieden- heit in der Wirkungsstarke von Links-, inaktivem und Rechts-Hyoscyamin. 26p. 8? Marb., 1927. Dehorter, L. Action de la genhyoscyamine sur la fonction cardioinhibitrice du pneumogastrique. C. rend. Soc. biol., 1926, 94: 395.—Della Rovere, O. La yosciamina nelle malattie mentali (note di pratica psichiatrica) Med. prat., Nap., 1928, 13: 241-8.—Fantus, B. Compound elixir of chloral and potas- sium bromide; the use of hyoscyamine hydrobromide. Bull. Nat. Formulary Com. U. S., 1939-40, 8: 50-2.—Mauerer, A. Ueber das Antispasmodicum Solamin. Deut. Aerzte Ztg, 1936, 11: No. 425.—Snider, E. H. Compound elixir of chloral and potassium bromide, the use of hyoscyamine hydrobromide in. Bull. Nat. Formulary Com. U. S., 1938-39, 7: 259.—Susanna, V. Sull'avvelenamento acuto e cronico da giusquiamina e da scopolamina. Arch. farm, sper., Roma, 1928-29, 46: 267; 273. -----Sull'attiviti biologica della d-giusquiamina. Fisiol. & med., Roma, 1930, 1: 551-5.—Tilden. Recherches sur I'hyoscyamine J. chim. med., Par., 1867, 5. ser., 3: 455.— Vreven, S. Contribution k l'etude de l'identification de I'hyoscyamine. Ann. pharm., Louvain, 1900, 6: 51-6, incl. pli HYOSCYAMUS. See also Hyoscyamine; Scopolamine; Solana- ceae. Caines, C. M. The assay of hyoscyamus leaves and extract of Hyoscyamus B. P. Q J. Pharm., Lond., 1929, 2: 271-5 — Dekay H. G., & Jordan, C. B. The assay of hyoscyamus. J. Am. Pharm. Ass., 1934, 23: 316.—Evans, M. D., & Davy, E. D. The assay of hyoscyamus. Ibid., 388-91.—Fahmy, I. R.. & Mangoury, H. A. el. Le dosage de l'Hyoscyamus muticus (Linne) C. rend. Congr. internat. pharm., 1935, 198-210.— Fischer, M. Anthozyanf uhrende Schliesszellen bei Hyoscyamus ein Beitrag zur Stoffverteilung in Epidermis- und Schliess- zellen. Biol, gen., Wien, 1930, 6: 293-318.—Goddijn, W. A. [Experimental cultivation of Linnd's annual Hyoscyamus niger] Genetica, Gravenh., 1926, 8: 161-328, pl. ------ [Tests of one-year plants of Hyoscyamus niger Linne] Pharm. wbl., Amst., 1927, 64: 81; 118.—Gore, L. F. Tincture of hyoscyamus. Pharm. J., Lond., 1933, 130: 483.—Hauser, W. Die Sphaerokristalle bei Hyoscyamus niger. Arch. Pharm., Berl., 1938, 276: 461-3, pl.—Klan. Z. F. Influence of period of vegetation and development of plant on the alkaloidal content of Hyoscyamus niger L. J. Am. Pharm. Ass., 1931, 20: 1163- 75.—Konowalowa, R. A., & Magidson, O. J. Ueber die Alkaloide des Hyoscyamus reticulatus L. Arch. Pharm., Berl., 1928, 266: 449-52.—Modi, J. P. Hyoscyamus niger, henbane, Khorasani ajwayan. In his Textb. Med. Jurispr., 6. ed., Bombay, 1940, 750-2.—Novlianskaia, K. A. [Acute poisoning with henbane] J. nevropat. psikhiat., Moskva, 1931, 24: 55- 62.—Nunn, A. W. Hyoscyamus assay. Pharm. J., Lond., 1933, 130: 294.—Ragab Fahmy, I. Egyptian Hyoscyamus muticus, Linne. C. rend. Congr. internat. med. trop. hyg., 1932, 5: 501-38, 5 pl.—S. & Gruber, C. M. Hyoscyamus. Cyclop. Med. (Piersol-Bortz) Phila., 1939, 7: 371-5.—Schaller, N. C, & Baldinger, L. H. A note on the assay of Hyoscyamus. J. Am. Pharm. Ass., 1932, 21: 442.—Schilizzi. Empoisonne- HYOSCYAMUS 952 HYPEREMIA ment par ingestion des racines de jusquiame noire, appn'tres on ragout. Gaz. med. Montpellier, 1852-53, 13: 1-I.V-Skala- Rosenbaum. J. [Poisoning by Hvoscvamus niger) (.'as. lek. Cesk., 1931, 70: 97.—Scoccianti. A. Estratto idi oalcoolieo di giusquKimo. Boll. chim. farm., 19.". 1, 70: 355-8.— Troup. R. M. A case of liNOscyiiinub. Pacific Coast J. Homoeop.. 1938, 49: 235-7.—Valentin. II. Ueber die Herstellung und Werthestim- niung von Oleum hyoscyami. Apoth. Ztg, 1926, 41: 752.— WaflTensmith, J. W. Mental essentials of Hyoscyamus. Homoeop. Rec, 1939, 54: No. 10, 20-2. HYOSTRONGYLUS. See also Trichostrongylidae. Hoogland, H. J. M. [Hyostrongylus rubidus in hogs. Tschr. diergeneesk., 1926, 53: 4-8, pl. ------ & Seijffers, S. M. [Worms (Hyostrongvlosis) in the stomach of young pigs] Ibid., 1928, 55: 377-87.—Kouri, P., Arenas, R., & Basnuevo, J. G. Hyostrongylosis del cerdo; reporte de un caso insolito con extensas lesiones papilomatosas. Cr6n. med. quir. Habana, 1934, 60: 8-10, pl. HYPAPHORINE. Cahill, W. M., & Jackson, R. W. Some observations on hypaphorine; racemization of its ester and properties of other derivatives. J. Biol. Chem., 1938, 126: 627-31. Also repr. HYPER ... For diseases and excessive functions see also under names of organs, functions, and secretions: e.g., Gastric juice, Acidity, excessive for Hyper- acidity; or, Cholesterosis for Hypercholesteri- nemia, &c. HYPERASPIS. Dobzhansky, T. Beetles of the genus Hyper- aspis inhabiting the United States. 94p. 24^cm. Wash., 1941. HYPEREMESIS gravidarum. See under Pregnancy. HYPEREMIA. See also Blood circulation,Disorders;Erythema; Inflammation, &c. Albrecht, E. *Die konsensuelle Hyperaemie [Freiburg] 23p. 21cm. Wiirzb., 1936. Jung, H. *Ueber die Warmestrahlung der menschlichen Haut bei den verschiedenen Arten von Hyperamie [Munchen] 15p. 8? Diisseld., 1934. Aiello, J. Ueber den Einfluss der venosen Stauung auf den Quellungszustand der Blutkorperchen. Biochem. Zschr., 1921, 124: 100-5— Barsoum, G. S., & Smirk, F. H. Observations on the increase in the concentration of a histamine-like sub- stance in human venous blood during a period of reactive hyperaemia. Clin. Sc, Lond., 1935-36, 2: 353-5.—Buttersack. Fluxionen und Kongestionen. Deut. med. WTschr., 1940, 66: 15-7.—Carlberg, B. O. Ueber den Verlauf und gewisse Konse- quenzen der Volumveranderungen des Unterarms bei An- bringung verschieden hoher und verschieden lange wahrender Manscliettondrueke um Oberarm. Uppsala lak. foren. forh., 1934, 39: 261-91.—Huggins, C. B., Blocksom, B. H., jr, & Wilson, H. Thermal changes in local asphyxia and reactive hyperemia. Arch. Surg., 1936, 32: 528-43.—Kwiatkowski, H. Observations on the relation of histamine to reactive hyperae- mia. J. Physiol., Lond., 1941, 100: 147-58.—Marcou, I., Comsa, G., & Chiriceano, D. Hyperemie par reaction et histamine. Bull. Acad. med. Roumanie, 1937, 3: 353-9.— Schneider, D., & Nase, H. Ueber die reaktive Hyperamie nach Untersuchungen mit der Thermostromuhr. Verh. Deut. path. Ges., 1937, 29: 331-4.—Thaler, W. H. Hyperemia. Am. Med., 1936, 42: 145-7.—Wehner, E. Ueber die periphere Blutzirkulation wahrend der reaktiven Hyperamie nach Blut- leere. Klin. Wschr., 1925, 4: 2005-8. ---- Therapeutic use. See also Diathermy; Histamine; Massage; Stasis; Thermotherapy, &c. Casparitjs. Behandlung chirurgischer Leiden mit Hyperamie. 70p. 8? Xeudamm, 1924. Edelschild, F. *Die Hyperamie in der Zahnheilkunde unter besonderer Berucksichtigung von Jothion [Heidelberg] 8? Bruchsal [1930] Katz, K. *Die moderne Saugbehandlung im Lichte neuzeitlicher Indikationsstcllung [Mini- ster] 47p. 21cm. Dortmund-Mengede, 1937. Schoenerstedt, I. *Ueber die Hvperiimicbe- handlung. 24p. 21cm. Rostock, 1936. Waksmundzka, M. G. Pneumatic therapy (balancing the vasomotor system) (JuikxI'h haemospasia) (Bier's hyperemia) 2. ed. Hip. 8? N. Y.[1936] Bactericidal (The) effect of hyperemia. Pharm. Advance, 1937, 12: No. 139, 7-9.—Bescht. Erfahrungen mit Anab-it- hyperamie bei speziellen Indikationen. Med. Klin., Hei I 1929, 25: 1632-4, pl.—Blasek, S. Heilhypernmie durch Kata- plasmabehandlung. Med. Welt, 1933, 7: 1753.—Botella. K. Resultados personales de la aspiraci6n de Bier en otologfa. Libro de actas Congr. nac. otorinolar., Madr., 1912, 4. Congr., 161-70.—Clemm, W. N. Ueber ein neues Mittel, durch Ein reibung Hyperamie zu erzielen. Aerztl. Rdsch., 1926. 36: 228a.—Diemer, T. Der galvanische Strom in seinen Beziehun- gen zur Hyperamie und Wundheilung. Deut. Zschr. Chir., 1927, 203:-204: 575-86.—Eckhart. Neueres zur Hyperamie- behandlung. Deut. med. Wschr., 1936, 62: 1506.—Feilchen- feld, L. Stau-Schelle. Med. Klin., Berl., 1929, 25: 113.— Grosse-Brockhoff, F., Schneider, M., & Schoedel, W. Ueber yasomotorische Interferenzen im Muskelgefassnetz bei kunst- licher Hyperamie durch gefasserweiternde Substanzen. Arch. ges. Physio!., 1936, 237: 178-89.—Heys. A. On Bier's (arterial) hyperaemie method. Lancet, Lond., 1931, 2: 1073.—Hirsch- bruch, A. Ueber die Wirkungsweise der hyperamisierenden Hautreizbehandlung insbesondere mit Analgit. Fortsch. Med., 1928, 46: 1134.—Hoeflinger, B. Device for collecting the blood at a certain part of the human body. U. S. Patent Off., 1936, No. 2,044,691.—Kappeli, A. Ueber Histamin- lontophorese; ein neues Verfahren zur aktiven Hvperamiebe- handlung. Schweiz. med. Wschr., 1934, 64: 489-91*.—Lohr, W. Grundlagen und Ausfiihrung der Behandlung durch Stauung. Deut. med. Wschr., 1926, 52: 920.—Osborn, T. W. B. A note on the influence of stasis on haemolytic complement: a contri- bution to the rationale of Bier's passive hyperaemia. ,1. Path. Bact., Cambr., 1935, 40: 617-9.—Pique, J. A., & Dubin, L. Nueva contribucion al estudio del masaje vascular. Sum. med., B. Air., 1939, 46: pt 2, 520-6.—Ruhmann, W. Ueber Heil- hyperamie; ihre Grundlagen im Lichte neuerer Forschung. Munch, med. Wschr., 1933, Jubil., Teil 1, 17-21.—Ryszkiewicz, A. Zur Kritik der Fliichenreiztherapie. Fortsch. Ther., 1933, 9: 273-6.—Schafer, H. Biersche Hyperamie, ein in Kamerun bekanntes Heilverfahren. Arb. Tropenkrankh. (Festschr. B. Nocht) Hamb., 1927, 475, pl.—Schneider, A. Wie konnen wir auf einfache Weise Hyperamie erzeugen? Aerztl. Rdsch., 1926, 36: 314.—S., & Shallow, T. A. Hyperemia, Bier's. Cyclop. Med. (Piersol-Bortz) Phila., 1939, 7: 376-84.— Thiele, W. Ueber die Behandlung mit aktiver Hyperamie nach Ganter. Miinch. med. Wschr., 1938, 85: 988-90.— Towbin, W. L. Bhythmische aktiv-passive Hyperamie als Heilmittel. Acta rheumat., Rotterdam, 1935, 7: No. 24,9-13. HYPERESTHESIA. See Sensation, Disorder. HYPERGLOBULIA. See Erythremia. HYPERGLYCEMIA. See Blood sugar, high. HYPERICUM [and hypericism] See also Photosensitization. Daniel. Johanniskraut (Hypericum perforatum) bei psychischen Storungen. Hippokrates, Stuttg., 1939, 10: 929-32.—Hall, A. Z. Everyday uses of Hypericum. J. Am. Inst. Homeop., 1940, 33: 181. Hausman, W. Ueber den Hypericismus; zugleich ein Beitrag zur Geschichte der Licht- pathologie. Strahlentherapie, 1931, 41: 145-54. ------ & Zaribnicky, F. Zur Kenntnis des Hypericismus. Klin. Wschr., 1929, 8: 74.—Horsley, C. H. Investigation into the action of St John's wort. J. Pharm. Exp. Ther., 1934, 50: 310-22.— Lecierc, H. Les rem&Ies des champs et des bois: le millepertuis (Hypericum perforatum L.) Presse med., 1926, 34: 1166.— Melas-Joannides, Z. Le pigment phototoxique de l'Hypericum crispum. Arch. Inst. Pasteur helien., 1928-30, 2: 339-42.— Pace, N., & Mackinney, G. Hypericin, the photodynamic pigment from St John's wort. J. Am. Chem. Soc, 1941, 63: 2570-4. HYPERINSULINISM. See Blood sugar, low; also Insulin, Poisoning. HYPERKERATOSIS. See Keratosis. HYPERKINESIA 953 HYPERNEPHROMA HYPERKINESIA. See also under names of parts affected as Face, Movement, disordered; also Neurosis, &c. Laufer, M. *Nachuntersuchungen an hy- perkinetischen Kindern. 31p. 22V2cm Berl 1937. Firth, D. Case of hyperkinesis of doubtful cause. Proc R Soc. M., Lond., 1926-27, 20: Sect. Stud. Dis. Child., 46 — Herman, H., & Zeldowicz, H. Sur un cas d'hemihyperkinesie insolite chez un vieillard. Rev. neur., Par., 1936, 43: pt 2 643.— Kuslik, M. I. [Orthopedics in treatment of hyperkinesis] Khirurgia, Moskva, 1937, No. 1, 81-92.—Omorokow, L. J. Zur Frage iiber die differentialdiagnostische Bedeutung der corticalen und mesencephalischen Hyperkinesen. Zschr ges Neur. Psychiat., 1926, 106: 79-95.—Ricaldoni, A. Clasifica- ci6n semiologica de las hiperquinesias. An. Fac. med., Montev 1919, 4: 842-55.—Russetzki, J. Sur les hypercinesies. Ence- phale, 1931, 26: 739-55.—Saradjichvili, P. Une forme clinique particuliere de l'hypercinesie chez l'enfant. Ibid., 1933 28- 663-70.—Weigand, W., & Guttmann, E. Zur chirurgischen Therapie hyperkinetischer Erscheinungen. Miinch med Wschr., 1926, 73: 1797. HYPERMETROPIA. See also Eye refraction, Ametropia. Mohler, E. *Bericht iiber die Falle hoherer Weitsichtigkeit an der Wiirzburger Augenklinik in den Jahren 1929-33 [Wurzburg] 12p. 8? Bottrop, 1935. Corrado, A. Sull'ipermetropia di grado elevato." Rass. ital. ottalm., 1935, 4: 87-107.—Cowan, A. Hypermetropia Am. J. Ophth., 1939, 3. ser., 22: 998-1002.—Dupuy-Dutemps, L. Adaptation de l'ceil aphaque k la vision rapprochee par l'eioignement de la lentille correctrice pour la vision au loin. Ann. ocul., Par., 1933, 170: 509-12.—Feinbloom, W. Hypero- pia and contact lenses. Optic. J., 1941, 78: No. 3, 21-3.— Gallerani, G. Come e perche si possa, con uno specchio sfero- concavo corregere e misurare una ipermetropia. Ann. ottalm., 1936, 64: 801-10.—Haas, E. Calcul approche de l'amplitude accommodative que donne a l'aphaque, et plus generalement k l'hypermetrope, le deplacement antero-posterieur de son verre de distance. Bull. Soc. opht. Paris, 1933, pt 1, 29-31.— Henao, M. H. La hipermetropia; sus causas y su correccion. Repert. med. cir., Bogota, 1929, 20: 232-7.—Holger Ehlers. [Refraction increase in hvpermetropia in a student] Hos- pitalstidende, 1935, 78: [Oft. selsk. forh.] 18.—Jensen, V. A. Transitory non-diabetic hypermetropia in a patient on reducing diet. Acta ophth., Kbh., 1932, 10: 388-93.—Jones, L. W. Changes in refraction after operation for retrobulbar tumor. Am. J. Ophth., 1942, 25: 482.—Lambert, R. K., & McDannald, C. E. Hereditary high hyperopia. Ibid., 1931, 3. ser., 14: 46-8.—Padovani, S. Un caso di ipermetropia elevata. Arch. ottalm., 1933, 40: 145-9.—Peckham, R. M. Latent hyperopia, base-in prisms and cross-cylinders. Optometr. Week., 1932-33, 23: 161; 189.—Review (A) of certain ocular cases in which hyperopia was undercorrected. Am. J. Optometr., 1939, 16: 349-61.—Santos Fernandez, J. La hipermetropia senil. An. oft., Mex., 1898-99, 1: 201-5.—Sehanz, F. Weiteres iiber die Entstehung der Weitsichtigkeit und des Altersstars. Arch. Ophth., Lpz., 1915, 89: 556-61.—Stromberg, E. [Exi- gency for acuity of vision and farsightedness according to the regulations of 1936] Sven. lak. tidn., 1937, 34: 894-900 — Vita, A. Sulle cause dell'intolleranza di alcuni ipermetropi di alto grado per le lenti a menisco. Rass. ital. ottalm., 1934, 3: 753-63.—Vogelsang. Exzessive Hypermetropic bei Kon- sanguinitat der Eltern. Zschr. Augenh., 1938, 94: 103. HYPERNEPHROMA. See also Suprarenal gland, ectopic; also under names of organs affected as Kidney, etc. Ammer, H. K. J. *Knochenmetastasen bei Hypernephrom, zugleich ein Beitrag zur Frage der Operation von Solitarknochenmetastasen. 28p. 8? Kiel, 1932. Haffner, J. *Heilungsergebnisse bei Hyper- nephromen und die Grunde fiir das Versagen der operativen Behandlung [Wurzburg] 19p. 8? Eisfeld, 1937. Hansher, E. hypernephroma. 16p. Mil- waukee, Wis., 1937. Hermann, G. *Ueber hypernephrome-hyper- nephroide Gewachse, unter besonderer Beriick- sichtigung ihrer atypischen Lokalisationen mit zwei eigenen derartigen Fallen [Heidelberg] 40p. 8? Bottrop, 1932. Lippmann, M. *Metastasen als Friihsym- tome langsam wachsender Hypernephrome [Breslau] 30p. 8? Wurzb., 1935. . Michel, E. *Ueber Diagnose und Differen- tialdiagnose bei Grawitzschen Tumoren [Gies- sen] 33p. 8? Wiirzb., 1938. Rehfisch, M. *Zur Frage der ursachlichen Beziehungen zwischen Trauma und Hyper- nephrom [Basel] 15p. 8? BerL, 1935. Schmitz, W. *Zwei Falle von Hyperne- phrom-Metastasen im Siebbeingebiet und im Oberkiefer. 19p. 22cm. Berk, 1936. Schuster, H. *Zur Kenntnis des Hyper- nephroms an Hand von 80 Fallen des Erlanger Pathologischen Instituts. 19p. 21cm. Erlangen 1936. Vogel, A. *Die vom 1. Januar 1928 bis zum 30. September 1932 an der chirurgischen Uni- versitatsklinik zu Konigsberg operierten Falle von Hypernephrom. 38p. 8? Konigsb., 1933. Albarran, J. Tumeur polykystique perirenale developpee aux depens du corps de Wolff. Bull. Soc. chir. Paris, 1903, n. ser., 29: 117-21.—Alessandri, R. Sui tumori pulsanti delle ossa ed in modo speciale sulle metastasi di ipernefromi nello scheletro. Policlinico, 1926, 33: sez. chir., 273-314.—Almeida Prado, A. de. Hypernephroma maligno atypico; tumor solido do hypocondno esquerdo. In his Lie. conf. clin. med., S. Paulo, 1934, 120-4.—Anardi, T. Sui tumori ipernefroidi a sede renale ed epatica. Tumori, 1928, 14: 337-72, 12 pl.—Baiocchi, P. Le cadre lipidique de la tumeur de Grawitz et sa signification dans Interpretation nosologique des hvpernephromes. J chir., Par., 1940, 56: 02 (microfilm) —Banyai, S. Hyper- nephroma esete. Budapesti orv. ujs., 1904, 2: 92-4.—Barney, J. D. Extrarenal hypernephroma. Tr. Am. Ass. Genitourin. Surgeons, 1939, 32: 47-56.—Bevan, A. D. Hypernephroma. Ann. Surg., 1904, 39: 468.—Bashkevich, V. N. [Significance of topographic palpation in diagnosis of hypernephroma] Ter. arkh., 1935, 13: 119-25.—Bolten, G. C. [Hypernephroma as brain tumor; case] Ned. tschr. geneesk., 1929, 73: pt 1, 2249- 55.—Bull, P. Treatment and prognosis of hypernephroma. Acta chir. scand., 1935, 76: 270-82.—Biineeler, W., & Martins de Castro, A. Ueber eine eigenartige diffuse Hautinfiltration durch Hypernephrommetastasen. Virchows Arch., 1938-39, 303: 570-5.—Cadenat, P. M. Deux observations d'hyper- nephromes. Bull. Soc. nat. chir., Par., 1934, 60: 728-32.— Caporale, L. A proposito di un caso di ipernefroma senza dati sintomatologici ed obbiettivi urinari. Cancro, Tor., 1933, 4: 304-10, pl.—Carlson, H. E., & Ockerblad, N. F. A case of unoperated hypernephroma of 10 years' duration. Am. J. Roentg., 1941, 45: 221.—Carneiro de Moura, A. Um caso de hipernefroma com aortografia. Lisboa med., 1934, 11: 826- 30.—Case of hypernephroma with bone metastases; history and pathological report. Canad. M. Ass. J., 1926, 16: 691-4.— Cheesman, W. S. Extirpation of a hypernephroma, weighing 4J4 pounds from an infant 20 months of age; recovery. Ann. Surg., 1907, 45: 91-3, 2 pl.—Chute, A. L. A study of some cases of hypernephroma. Boston M. & S. J., 1920, 194: 471- 8.—Chwalla. Ungewohnliclie Falle von Hypernephrom. Zschr. urol. Chir., 1935-36, 41: 564-6—Cibert, J., Meysson- nier & Perrin, J. A propos de la longue durie devolution de certains hypernephromes. Lyon med., 1938, 162: 196-8.— Clinical pathological conference. Tufts M. J., 1941-42, 8: 79-83.—Creevy, C. D. Pyrexia in malignant nephroma (hypernephroma) J. Am. M. Ass., 1929, 92: 1256-60.— Creyssel, Berard, M., & Vincent, E. Hypernephrome meta- statique. Lyon chir., 1938, 35: 576-8.—Darrach, B. Multiple hypernephromata with normal adrenals in a hedgehog. Proc. Path. Soc. Philadelphia, 1920-21, n. ser., 23: 54.— Debarge, C. Etude d'un cas d'hypernephrome avec aplasie surrenale; de la fonction des tumeurs malignes. J. physiol. path. g6n., Par., 1928, 26: 668-83.—De Busscher, J. Metastase cranienne solitaire et k evolution rapide dun hypernephrome. J. beige neur. psychiat., 1935, 35: 741-5.—Dfez, J., & Michans, J. Tumores pulsfitiles de los huesos; las metastasis esqueieticas del hipernefroma. Prensa med. argent., 1936, 23: 1991-2001 — Dorsett, W. D. A case of hypernephroma. S. Louis M. Rev., 1904, 50: 385.—Dresser, R. Metastatic manifestation of hypernephroma in bone. Am. J. Roentg., 1925, n. ser., 13: 342-53.—Ferstel, K. von. Zur Frage der extrarenalen, retro- peritonealen Tumoren. Deut. Zschr. Chir., 1936, 247: 517- 25.—Gaume, P. Metastase perineale d'un hypernephrome. Bull. Soc. fr. urol., 1937, 119-24. Also J. urol. med., Par., 1937, 43: 463-5.—Gaylor, J. B., & Howie, J. W. Brown-Sequard syndrome; a case of unusual aetiology. J. Neur. Psychiat., Lond., 1938, n. ser., 1: 301-5.—Gerwer, A. W. Ueber die Metastasen der Hypernephrome im Grosshirn. Arch. Psychiat. Berl., 1929, 88: 345-57.—Givatoff, G. K. Des erreurs de diagnostic en gynecologie; contribution k l'etude des hyper- nephromes simulant un kyste de l'ovaire. Gyn. obst., Par. 1928, 17: 251-61.—Giitig, C, & Herzog, A. Beitrag zur Kasuistik der extrarenalen Hypernephrome und zur Diagnostik HYPERNEPHROMA 954 HYPERNEPHROMA der retroperitonealen Geschwulste. Zschr. Urol., 1937, 31: 34-40.—Hintze, A. Knochenmetastasen des Hypernephroms; Erkenntnis und Schicksal. Fortsch. Rontgenstrahl., 1936, 54: 129—44.—Johannsen, R. Zur Prognose der Hypernephrome. Beitr. klin. Chir., 1939, 170: 130 9. Also Zbl. Chir., 1939, 66: 2416.—Jorns, G. Ueber die Koile des Traumas bei der Entste- hung hvpernepln -ider Gescli«ulste. Beitr. klin. Chir., 1936, 163: 354-04— Keen, W. W.. Pfiihler. G. K., & Ellis, A. G. On hypernephroma. Am. Med., 1904, 8: 1039-50.—Kamile Sevki. Ueber r men Fall von bosartigem Hypernephrom. C. rend. ("ongr. inn mat. path, comp., 1936, 3. Congr., 248-53.— Hasten. H. E. Metastasis in hypernephroma. J. Urol., Bait., 1939, 42: 92-100.- kimura, T. On the frequency of occurrence of hypernephroma corticale et medullare in the horse and the cattle. Sei i kwai M. J., 1921, 40: No. 5, 8.—Krecke, A. Hypernephrome. In his Beitr. prakt. Chir., Munch., 1934, 537-48.—Krivtzov, T. [Case history of metastatic hyper- nephroma] Omsky med. J., 1926, 1 : No. 4-5, 75-7.—Kulkow, A. E., & Duochownikowa, L. M. Hypernephrommetastase in einem Riickenmark von heterotopischer Struktur. Deut. Zschr. Nervenh., 1931, 121: 255-69.—Kusunoki. T. Ueber einen Fall von oxtrarmalein Hypernephrom. Zschr. Urol., 1938, 32: 618-22.—Legault, J. P. Hypernephrome sans manifestations urinaires. J. Hotel Dieu Montreal, 1936, 5: 51-6.—Lehmann, W. Hvpernephrommetastasen des Skelct- systems. Arch. khn. Chir., 1932. 170: 331-80.—Leitch, D. B. Medullary hypernephroma witli cranial metastases. Tr. Canad. Soc. Stud. Dis. Child., 1924. 2: 90-5.—Lepehne, G. Hypernephrom mit Cystenbildung. Med. Khn., Berl., 1930. 26: 698.—Levitansky, G. 1. [Hypernephroma in a child] Sovet. vrach. J., 1938, 42: 869.—Marques, P., & Dieulafe, R. Metastases osseuses, premier symptome d'un hypernephrome latent. Gaz. med. France, 1940, 47: 133.—Marziani, R. Tumore a tipo cortico surrenale bilaterale in un Colombo. Tumori, 1926, 12: 379-87.—Melchior, E. Extrarenale Lage eines Hypernephroms. Zbl. Chir., 1936, 63:1010-2.—Mendoza- Guazon, M. P. Studies on tumors among Filipinos; hyper- nephroma. J. Philippine Islands M. Ass., 1929, 9: 199-201.— Michejda, K. Extrarenale Lage eines Hypernephroms. Zbl. Chir., 1935, 62: 1163-5.—Milani, E. Sul relievo radiologico precoce di lesioni ossee solitarie a tipo metastatico negli iperne- fromi latenti. Q. radiol., Bclluno, 1937, n. ser., 1: 35-40.— Moura, P. Hypernephromas. Fol. med., Rio, 1927, 8: 225- 7.—Oppikofer, E. Die Hypernephrommetastasen in den oberen Luftwegen und im Gehororgan. Arch. Ohr. &c. Heilk., 1931, 129: 271-92.—Paez. J. Dos casos de hipernefroma. An. Hosp. S. Jose, Madr., 1933-34, 5: 43-8, 2 pl.—Paolucci, F. Ipernefroma eterologo benigno in sacco erniario (contributo isto-patologico) Ann. ital. chir., 1927, 6: 666-77.—Price, L. T. Hypernephroma: diagnosis and report of cases; with lantern slide demonstration. Virginia M. Month., 1936-37, 63: 541- 8.—Rae, M. V. Spontaneous regression of a hypernephroma. Am. J. Cancer, 1935, 24: 839-41.—Reddineius [Hyper- nephroma; case] Geneesk. tschr. Ned. Indie, 1941, 81: 2569. — Riiey, H. W. Long standing pyrexia due to hypernephroma. Manitoba M. Ass. Rev., 1940, 20: 127.—Rittmann, R. Zur Diagnose de* Hypernephroms. Med. Klin., Berl., 1930, 26: 658-62.— Roche. A. E. Five-year-old hypernephroma. Proc. It. Soc. M., Lond., 1940-11, 34: 667—Rosenstein, P. Ueber Hypernephrome; bemerkenswerte Fnihfalle und Resektion bei Spiitfallen. Zbl. Chir., 1932, 59: 1138-44.—Roskin, G. Ver- gleichend zytologische Beobachtungen an den Hypernephromen von Meerschweinchen und an dessen Explantaten in vitro. Arch. exp. Zellforsch., 1931, 11: 669-89, pl.—Roth, L. J., & Davidson, H. B. Metastatic pulsating tumors of the sternum secondaiy to renal hypernephroma. Tr. North Centr. Br. Am. liol. Ass., 1936, 16-25.— Saito. Y. Ein Fall des malignen Hypeniephroms mit hartnackiger Lumbago. J. Orient. M., Dairen, 1937, 26: 34.—Salter, P. H. Hypernephroma. Ne- braska M. J., 1928, 13: 401-4.—Schiller, W. Histogenesis of the so-called Grawitz tumor. Proc. Inst. M. Chicago, 1942—43, 14: 82^4.—Schnee-Warsar, S. Zur Kasuistik der Hyper- nephrome (ein Fall von Hypernephrommetastase im Gehirn unter dem Bilde einer Apoplexie) Frankf. Zschr. Path., 1926, 34: 327-36.—Schwaiger, M. Zur Frage der sarkomatosen Entartung und Metastasierung hypernephroider Geschwulste. Ibid., 1938, 52: 500-10.—Sexton. W. G. Cortical hyper- nephroma; report of case. Proc. Inst. M. Chicago, 1942—43, 14: 151.—Shcheglova, A. A. [Metastasis of hypernephroma into the vascular tunic of the eye] Vest, oft., 1941, 18: 407- 13.—Shuman, J. W., & Allison, W. C. Hypernephroma of bone; case report. Med. World, 1925, 43: 290-2.—Smyth, M. J. Silent hypernephromata. Brit. J. Surg., 1939-40, 27: 266-74.—Stirling, W. C. Adrenal-rest tumor; report of an unusual case. Med. Ann. District of Columbia, 1935, 4: 111- 3.—Sukhanov, G. A. [Hypernephromas] Urologia, Moskva, 1934, 11: 31-5.—Taterka, H. Nervensymptome bei Hyper- nephrommetastasen im Knochensystem. Nervenarzt, 1928, 1: 170-2.—Tenenbaum, J. Hypernephroma associated with hyperplasia and metastatic carcinoma of the adrenals. Am. J. Surg., 1941, 52: 120-8.—Thompson, R. L. Remarks on the pathology of hypernephroma. S. Louis M. Rev., 1904, 50: 386.—Tomoff, W. Hypernephroma dex. mit policystischer Degeneration. Zschr. Urol., 1937, 31: 67.—Tylec, L. L. Hypernephroma with metastases to scapula; case report. Connecticut M. J., 1941, 5: 432.—Tzschirntsch. Hyper- nephrom. Zschr. Urol., 1936, 30: 803.—Valade, P. Nephrome k cellules claires (hypernephrome) du chien. Rec. med. v6t., 1935, 111: 577-82.—Varner, C. A. Metastatic hyper- nephroma; case report. Memphis M. J., 1940, 15: 115.—Veil, K. [Case of Grawitz' tumor] Askeri sihhiye mecmuasi, 1934, 63: 70-73.—Verbfcnyi, B. [Case of hypernephroma) Orv. hetil., 1938, 82: 694.—Vilardell. J., & Corachfin l.lort, M. Un caso de hipernefroma (comentarios a su histogenesis) Rev. cir., Barcel., 1933, 6: 34-43.—Wharton. L. R. Hypernephromas that aie too early to diagnose. .1. I'rol., Bait., 1939, 42: 713- 9.—Wod.sack. H. Beitrag zur Klinik der Hypernephrome Beitr. klin. Chir., 1927, 139: 108-28.—Zampa, G. Sulla istogenesi del cosidetto tumore di Grawitz. Arch. ital. urol., 1933-34, 10: 201-45.- Zenker, R. Ueber Blutdrucksteigerung bei Hypernephrom. Zsehr. I'rol., 1936, 30: 561-3. HYPEROPIA. See Hypermetropia. HYPERPHORIA. See Eye muscles, Balance; also Strabismus. HYPERPIESIS. See Blood pressure, high. HYPERPLASIA [incl. hypoplasia] See also Epithelioma; Gigantism; Growth, Disorder; also under names of organs and parts affected. Wolf, H. *Die Frage der Genese der Hypo- plasien. 37p. 8? Bonn, 1931. Gruber, G. B., & Kuss, O. E. Der angeborene ortliche Riesemvuchs; Hyperplasia partialis congenita; Gigantomelie. In Morph. Missbild. (Schwalbe, E.) Jena, 1937, 3. T., 1. Abt., 423-54.—Hyperplasia and cancer. Annual Rep. Brit. Emp. Cancer Campaign, 1941, 18:102.—Rondoni, P. Die Regulierung der Wuehcrungsvorgange im Organismus. Jahrkurs. arztl. Fortbild., 1932, 23: H. 1, 78-92.—Winer. L. H. Pseudo- epitheliomatous hyperplasia. Arch. Derm. Syph., Chic, 1940, 42: 856-67. HYPERPNEA. See under Respiration. HYPERPYREXIA. See Fever. HYPERSENSITIVENESS. See Allergy. HYPERTELORISM. See also under names of paired organs. Abernethy, D. A. Hypertelorism in several generations. A.rch. Dis. Childh., Lond., 1927, 2: 361-5.—Allen, F. M. B. A case of hypertelorism without mental defect. Ibid., 1926, 1: 171-4.—Boil en, K., & Brems, T. Hypertelorism (Greig) Acta path, microb. scand., 1938, 15: 217-58.—Braithwaite, J. V. C. The relation of hypertelorism to mongolism; with description of a case. Arch. Dis. Childh., Lond., 1926, 1: 369-72.—De Blasio, R. L'ipertelorismo di Greig. Rinasc. med., 1935, 12: 169.—Dellepiane Rawson, R., & Gonzalez Avila, E. Hipertelorismo. Sem. med., B. Air., 1930, 37: pt 2, 1206-9.—Divry & Evrard, E. Plagiocephalie et hyperteiorismo unilateral chez un epileptique. J. beige neur. psychiat., 1935, 35: 75-82, 2 pl.—Drummond, W. B. A case of hypertelorism. Arch. Dis. Childh., Lond., 1926, 1: 166-70.—Kruger, E. Hypertelorismus bei einem vierjahrigen Madchen. Zschr. Kinderh., 1932-33, 54: 785-7.—Lightwood, R. C. Unilateral hypertelorism. Proc. R. Soc. M., Lond., 1928-29, 22: Sect. Stud. Dis. Child., 37. ------ & Sheldon, W. P. H. Hyper- telorism; an unilateral case. Arch. Dis. Childh., Lond., 1928, 3: 168-72.—Montford, T. McC. Hereditary hypertelorism without mental dificiency. Ibid., 1929, 4: 381-4.—Pickerill, H. P. Hypertelorism: notes on 3 cases. Brit. J. Surg., 1938-39, 26: 588-92.—Posner, I. Ocular hypertelorism with cleft palate and giant-cell tumor. Radiology, 1940, 35: 79-81.—Regnault, F., & Crouzon. O. Les hyperteiorismes. Ann. anat. path., Par., 1930, 7: 571-6.—Reilly, W. A. Hypertelorism; report of 4 cases. J. Am. M. Ass., 1931, 96: 1929-33.—Reuben, M. S., & Fox, H. R. Hypertelorism. Arch. Pediat., N. Y., 1928, 45: 105-15.—-Van Bogaert, L., & Sweerts, J. Sur l'hyperteiorisme de Greig (type sporadique et type hereditaire) J. beige neur. psychiat., 1935, 35: 71-4, 2 pl.—Vorisek, E. Ocular hyper- telorism of Greig. Am. J. Ophth., 1942, 25: [Discussion] 92- 5.—Washington, J. A. Hypertelorism. In Pract. Pediat. (Brennemann, J.) Hagerstown, 1937, 4: chap. 31, 3.—Wylle, W. G. Two cases of hypertelorism. Proc. R. Soc. M., Load., 1926-27, 20: Sect. Stud. Dis. Child., 14. HYPERTENSIN 955 HYPHOMYCETES HYPERTENSIN. Battro, A., Gonzalez Segura, R., & Lanari, A. La action de la hipertensina en sujetos normales e hipertensos. Rev. argent card., 1941-42, 8: 250-6.—Croxatto, H., & Croxatto, R. Natura- leza quimica de la hipertensina. Rev. Soc. argent, biol., 1941, 17: 439-60. Also Prensa med. argent., 1942, 29: 65. Pepsitensin; a hypertensinlike substance produced by peptic digestion of proteins. Science, 1942, 95: 101.—Croxatto, H., Croxatto, R. [et al.] Caracteristicas enzimiticas de la hiper- tensinasa. Rev. med. aliment., Santiago, 1941-42, 5: 69-71.— Fasciolo, J. C, Mufios, J. M., & Braun Menendez, E. Dosaje de la hipertensinasa. Prensa med. argent., 1941, 28: pt 1, 147. HYPERTHERMIA. See Fever; Fever therapy. HYPERVENTILATION. See Apnea. HYPERTRICHOSIS. See Hair. HYPERTROPHY. See also Gigantism; Hyperplasia; also under names of organs and parts affected. Boyd, E. M. Hypertrophy and lipid composition of frog tissues. J. Biol. Chem., 1937, 121: 783-6. Also repr.— Chernyshev, A. Zur Frage der Hypertrophie resp. Pseudo- hypertrophic Arch. Psychiat., Berl., 1929, 87: 455-70.— Creveld, S. van. Over de rol van het glycogeen bij het ontstaan van orgaanvergrootingen. Mschr. kindergeneesk., 1932-33, 2: 123-38. Also Klin. Wschr., 1933, 12: 529-33.—Debre, R. Les polycories. Presse med., 1935, 43: 801-3.—Esiable, C. Technique simple pour la biomicroscopie d'une augmentation quelconque du cceur et autres organes. C. rend. Soc. biol., 1937, 124: 591.—Mann, F. C. Study of organ hypertrophy. J. Pediat., S. Louis, 1935, 6: 721.—Petre, A. J., Schere, S., & Pellerano, J. C. Desarmonias hemicorporales congenitas; hemiatrofias 6 hemihipertrofias. Arch, argent, pediat., 1939, 11: 294-300.—Schachter, M. Megalosomias e hipertrofias locali- zadas. Medicina, Madr., 1941, 9: 5-9.—Sjamsoedin [Hemi- hypertrophia totalis congenita] Ned. tschr. geneesk., 1940, 84: 3444.—Stoesser, A. V. The hypertrophies of infancy and childhood. Am. J. Dis. Child., 1928, 35: 885-93. HYPESTHESIA. See also Analgesia; Esthesiometry. Stein, H., & Weizsacker, V. von. Der Abbau der sensiblen Funktionen; eine sinnesphysiologische Analyse der Hypasthesie. Deut. Zschr. Nervenh., 1927, 99: 1-30. HYPHOMICROBIUM. Boltjes, T. Y. K. Ueber Hyphomicrobium vulgare Stutzcr et Hartleb. Arch. Mikrob., Berl., 1936, 7: 188-205. HYPHOMYCETES. See also under names of genera as Dematium, &c. Aldick, W. Zimtchloroform, Sublimat und Jodtinktur in ihrer Wirkung auf Hyphomyceten. Arch. Derm. Syph., Berl., 1934 170-410-24.—Ballagi, I. Die Rolle der Schimmelpilze in der Dermatologie. Zbl. Haut. Geschlkr., 1930-31, 35: 593-8 — Berde, K. von. Das Verhalten von Fadenpilzkolonien unter der Wirkung des Lichtes. Arch. Derm. Syph., Berl., 1929. 158: 35-50—Blochwitz, A. Kulturmethoden fiir Schimmelpilze. Zbl. Bakt., 2. Abt., 1930, 81: 74-9.—Cerutti, P. Concentrazione idrogenionica e sviluppo degli ifomiceti patogeni. Pathologica, Genova, 1933, 25: 32-7. ------ & Verzola, M. Ulterior; ricerche sulle variazioni della concentrazione idrogenionica dei terreni culturali in rapporto alio sviluppo degli ifomiceti pato- geni ed alia loro attivita fermentativa. Gior. ital. derm, syph., 1936 77: 37-46.—Chrzqszcz, T., & Tiukow, D. Oxalsaure in Schimmelpilzkulturen. Biochem. Zschr., 1930, 218: 73-85.— Deschiens, R. Conditions de capture des larves de Dictyo- caules par des hyphomycetes predateurs Bull. Soc. path. exot Par., 1939, 32: 698-700, 2 pl—Drechsler, C. Three new hvohomycetes preying on free-living terncolous nematodes. Mycologia, Lancaster, 1940, 32: 448-70.—Falchi, G. Ifomicosi cutanee Gior. ital. derm, sif., 1928, 69: 911-3.—Fuchs, J. Schtomelpilze als Hefebildncr. Zbl. Bakt,, 2. Abt 1925-26, 66- 490-500, pl.—Hartmann. Demonstration von Menschen- pathogenen und saprophytischen Hyphomyceten Khn. Wschr. 1926, 5: 915.—Heidegger, E. Beitrag zur Farbung der Pilze von Favus und Herpes tonsurans. Derm. Wschr., 1928, 87: 1112-4— Hilgermann, M. Schimmelpilzerkrankungen des Menschen und ihre Therapie. Arch. Derm. Syph., Berl., 1934- 35 171- 593-609.—Hruszek, H. Methode zum Studiumdes Tiefenwachstums der Pilze nebst Bemerkungen zum Problem der Dermotropie der Hyphomyceten. Ibid., 1934, 170: 425- 64—Jong, D. A. de. Over eenige (huid-) schimmolziekten, bij oen mensch en bij dieren voorkomend, uit een oogpunt van hygiene Ned. tschr. geneesk., 1913, 1: 405-16.—Klieneberger, fc. Leber die Anfertigung von Schimmelpilzpraparaten fiir Kurszwecke. Zbl. Bakt., 1. Abt., 1928, 108:207-9.—Kostychev, ». Nitratassimdation bei Schimmelpilzen. Zschr. phvsiol Chem. 1927, 166: 135-41.-Mallinckrodt-Haupt, A. "von! Vitalfarbungen mit Indikatorfarben bei Hyphomyzeten. Derm Zschr., 1925-26, 46: 293-305.—Negroni, P. Otras Dematiaceae parasitas del hombre. Dia med., B. Air., 1930-31, 3: 434.— Niethe, U. Die Bedeutung der gewohnlichen Schimmelpilze fur die menschliche Haut. Arch. Derm. Syph., Berl., 1926, 152: 358-64.—Olah, D. Ueber die Schimmelpilze der erkrank- ten Haut und ihre Rolle bei der Entstehung, beziehungsweise beim Verlauf verschiedener Hautkrankheiten. Derm. Wschr 1935, 100: 703-12.—Provvedi, F. Sulla trasformazione del glucosio in acido citrico operata da ifomiceti. Riv. biol., 1926, 8: 16-22.— Pruess, L. M., Gorcica, H. J. [et al.] Wachstum und Steringehalt gewisser Schimmelpilze. Biochem. Zschr., 1932, 246: 401-13.—Storm van Leeuwen, W., & Kremer, W. Schimmelpilzallergene als Krankheitsursachen. Klin. Wschr 1927, 6: 408-11.—Stumpf, W. Ueber saprophytares Vor- kommen von Hypomyceten auf klinisch gesunder Haut unter besonderer Berucksichtigung der mosaic Fungi. Arch. Derm. Syph., Berl., 1934, 170: 449-55.—Sugiuchi, Y. Experimentelle Untersuchungen iiber die pathogenen Schimmelpilze. Fukuoka ikwadaigaku zasshi, 1928, 21: 61.—Sumstine, D. R. Studies in North American Hyphomycetes; the genera Rhinotrichum and Olpitrichum. Mycologia, N. Y., 1911, 3: 45-56, 3 pl.— Truffi, M. Hyphomycete du type Achorion determinant chez I'homme des lesions trichophytoides. Arch, parasit., Par., 1906r7, 12: 419-24. ------ & Benetazzo, G. Sviluppo di ifomiceti in rapporto alia concentrazione idrogenionica. Gior. ital. derm, sif., 1934, 75: Suppl., 238-41.—Unna, P., jr, & Fey, W. Ueber Farbung von Fadenpilzen. Zschr. wiss. Mikr., 1929, 46: 289-96—Watjen, J. Zur Kenntnis der Gewebsreaktionen bei Schimmelmykosen. Virchows Arch., 1928, 268: 665-85. HYPNOLEPSY. See Narcolepsy. HYPNOSIS. See also Autosuggestion; Catalepsy; Hypno- tism. Cuddon, E. Hypnosis; its meaning and prac- tice. 169p. 12? Lond., 1938. Dtjbor, G. de. Mysteries of hypnosis (les mysteres de l'hypnose) translated by G. M. Hort. 235p. 8? N. Y., 1923. Hull, C. L. Hypnosis and suggestibility; an experimental approach. 416p. 8? N. Y. [1933] Bass, M. J. Differentiation of the hypnotic tfance from normal sleep. J. Exp. Psychol., 1931, 14: 382-99.—Braceland, F. J. Hypnosis. In Cyclop. Med. (Piersol-Bortz) Phila., 1940, 12: 962-8.—Di Gaspero, H. Ueber Hypnose. Wien. khn. Wschr., 1928, 41: 1218-20.—Erickson, M. H. Hypnosis; a general review. Dis. Nerv. Syst., 1941, 2: 13-8.—Flatau, G. Experimenteller Hypnotismus. Psychother. Prax., Wien, 1934, 1: 155-9.—Haupt. Die Einteilung der Hypnosen. Psychiat. neur. Wschr., 1929, 31: 564.—Hull, C. L. Quantita- tive methods of investigating hypnotic suggestion. J. Abnorm. Psychol., 1930-31, 25: 200; 390.—Leuba, C. The use of hyp- nosis for controlling variables in psychological experiments. Ibid., 1941, 36: 271-4.—Urechia, C. J., & Rusdea, N. Auto- hypnose de longue dur6e ayant impose pour une catatonie. BuU. Soc. med. hop. Paris, 1922, 3. ser., 46: 1073.—Wells, W. R. Hypnotizability versus suggestibility. J. Abnorm. Psychol., 1930-31, 25: 436-49.—Young, P. C. Experimental hypnotism; a review. Psychol. Bull., 1941, 38: 92-104. ---- Dynamics. Brtjhn, C. A. Gelehrte in Hypnose; zur Psychologie der Ueberzeugung und des Traum- denkens. 3, 96p. 8? Hamb. [1926] Winslow, L. F. The suggestive power of hypnotism. 90p. 8? Lond. [1910] Ach, N. Ueber Suggestibilitat und Hypnotisierbarkeit. Zschr. ges. Neur. Psychiat., 1937, 158: 402-6.—Altshuler, I. M. Hypnotism and brain physiology. J. Michigan M. Soc, 1927, 26: 725-9.—Anastay, E. L'origine biologique de l'hypnose. Rapp. Congr. internat. psychol. (1909) 1910, 6. Congr., 601-7.— Betzendahl, W. Der abnorme Rapport. Allg. Zschr. Psychiat., 1939, 110: 187-200.—Biermann, B. Der Hypnotismus im Lichte der Lehre von den bedingten Reflexen. J. Psychol. Neur., Lpz., 1929, 38: 265-81.—Billstrom, J. Experimentelle Studien iiber Hypnotismus. Sven. lak. sail, handl., 1931, 57: 167-72.—Brickner, R. M., & Kubie, L. S. A miniature psy- chotic storm produced by a superego conflict over simple posthypnotic suggestion. Psychoanal. Q., 1936, 5: 467-87.— 56 HYPNOSIS HYPNOSIS Brown, W. Hypnosis, suggestibilitv and progressive relaxation. Rep. Brit. Ass. Advance. Sc, 1937, 107: 417. Also Brit. J. Psychol., 1937-3.S, 28: 390-411, pl.—Cannon. A. Notes upon li\ pnotic states. Lancet. Lond., 1932. 2: 11035.—Cantelmo t). Sulla soglia della ipno-narcosi. Gazz. internaz. med. chir., 1930, 38: 430-4.- Davis, L. W., & Husband, R. W. A study of hypnotic susceptibilitv in relation to personality traits. J. Abnorm. Psychol., 193i, 26: 175-82.—Dolin, A. O. [Objec- tive investigation of individual experience by experimental hypnosis] Arkh. biol. nauk, 193 1, spr. B, 36: 25-52.—Dorcus, R. M.. Brintnall. A. K., k Cane, H. W. Control experiments and their relation to theories of hypnotism. J. Gen. Psychol., 1941, 24: 217-21.—Eidelberg, L. Bemerkungen zur Physio- logie der in der Hypnose suggerierten Sinneseindriicke. Zschr. ges. Neur. Psychiat., 1928-29, 118: 144-50.—Erickson, M. H. Development of apparent unconsciousness during hypnotic reliving of a traumatic experience. Arch. Neur. Psychiat., Chic, 1937, 38: 12S2-8.------ Demonstration of mental mechanisms by hypnosis. Ibid., 1939, 42: 367-70.— Farez, P. L'hypnotisme et revocation du subconscient. C. rend. Congr. internat. psvchol. (1900) 1901, 4. Congr., 670-4 — Friedlander, J. W., & Sarbin, T. R. The depth of hypnosis. J. Abnorm. Psychol., 1938, 33: 453-75.—Frosch, J. S. Ueber die experimentelle Erzeugung von Traumen in der Hypnose. Ausz. Inaugur. Diss. Med. Fak. Univ. Bern (1935-37) 1938 No. 3, 1-4.—Gerundo, M. The influence of the sympathetic, parasympathetic and reticuloendothelial systems on experi- mental hypnosis and catatonia. J. Kansas M. Soc, 1937, 38: 471-7.—Haupt, J. Zur Frage nach der Entstehung des hyp- notischen Zustandes. Psychiat. neur. Wschr., 1926, 28: 123. ------ Weitere Beitrage zur Frage nach der Entstehung des hypnotischen Zustandes. Ibid., 345-7. Also Wien. med. Wschr., 1929, 79: 1122; 1125. ------ Experimentelle Unter- suchungen uber Eintritt und Ausbleiben von Hypnose. Deut. med. Wschr., 1938, 64: 234. ------ Psychologische Beob- achtungen bei Hypnosen. Psychiat. neur. Wschr., 1938, 40: 325.—Hibler, F. W. An experimental investigation of negative after-images of hallucinated colors in hypnosis. J. Exp. Psychol., 1940, 27: 45-57.—Hull, C. L. Quantitative methods of investigating hypnotic suggestion. J. Abnorm. Psychol., 1930-31, 25: 200-23.—Huse, B. Does the hypnotic trance favor the recall of faint memories? J. Exp. Psychol., 1930, 13: 519-29.—Ivanov-Smolensky, A. [Experiment in mechanisa- tion of hypnotic action] Vrach. dielo, 1928, 11: 221-4.— Kartamyshev, A., & Levit, N. [Hypnotic inhibitions and Midler's phenomenon] Sovrem. psikhonevr., 1930, 11: 55- 60 —Khersonsky, R. A., & Vetzner, A. M. [Rhythmic factors of hypnosis] Ibid., 1929, 9: 604-14.—Koster. S. Untersu- chungen iiber Hypnose. Zschr. ges.Neur.Psychiat., 1927,109: 49—61 —Krueger, E. Wie lasst sich Hypnose an Tieren und Kindern erklaren? Deut. med. Wschr., 1940, 66: 770 — Krueger, R. G. Variation in hypersuggestibility preceding, during and following the hypnotic trance. J. Abnorm. Psychol., 1931, 26: 131-40. ------ The influence of repetition and disuse upon rate of hypnotization. J. Exp. Psychol., 1931, 14: 260-9.—Kuravitsky, V. I. [Pathophysiology of hallucinations and other disorders of perception during hypnotic experiments] Nevropat. psikhiat., 1939, No. 11, 50-2. ------ [Physiology of symptoms, suggested in hypnosis (and produced by hysteria) from the view-point of the theory of the adaptation role of the sympathetic system] J. Physiol. USSR, 1940, 29: 413-6.— Marcuse, H. Zur Theorie der Hypnose. Arch. Psychiat., Berl., 1931, 95: 364-91.—Mitchell, M. B. Retroactive in- hibition and hypnosis. J. Gen. Psychol., 1932, 7: 343-59.— Nikolaiev, A. [Mechanism of hypnosis and the sympathetic nervous system] Vrach. gaz., 1927, 31: 1652-9.—Patten, E. F. The duration of post-hypnotic suggestion. J. Abnorm. Psychol., 1930-31, 25: 319-34, 2 pl.—Pen, R. M., & Dzhagarov, M. A. [Formation of conditioned reflex in hypnotic sleep] Arkh. biol. nauk, 1936, 42: 77-88.—Povorinsky, J. A., & Traugott, N. N. [Certain peculiarities of cortical dynamics during hypnotic sleep] Ibid., 44: 5-22.—Prince, M. Suggestive repersonalization, the psychophysiology of hypnotism. Arch. Neur. Psychiat., Chic, 1927, 18: 159-80. Also repr. Also in his Chn. Exp. Stud. Person., 2. ed., Cambr., 1939, 144-67 — Rabinovich, P. H. de. El mecanismo fisiologico de la hipnosis. Sem. med., B. Air., 1940, 47: pt 1, 1083-6.—Rothenberg, S. Theories of hypnosis and its uses. N. York State J. M., 1928, 28: 372-8.—Schnyder, L. L'examen de la suggestibilite chez les nerveux. Congr. med. alien, neur. France (1904) 1905, 2: 281-97.—Schuster, J. Zur Physiologie der hypnotischen Erscheinungen. Deut. Zschr. Nervenh., 1928, 107: 94-7 — Speyer, N., & Stokvis, B. Ueber die subjektiven Phanomene in der Hypnose. Psychiat. neur. bl., Amst., 1937, 41: 59-79. Also Brit. J. M. Psychol., 1937-38, 17: 217-22— Stein, M. R. A critical review of an investigation in the psychology of suggestion and hypnosis. J. Abnorm. Psychol., 1930-31, 25: 49-56.—Stockert. F. G. Die Physiologie der Hypnose. Ner- venarzt, 1930, 3: 462-7.—Sumbaev, I. S. [Effect of pharma- cological substances on hypnotic sleep] Sovet. nevropat., 1935, 4: No. 7, 83-94.—Suslova, M. M. [Experimental in- vestigations of the dynamics of hypnotic sleep in man] J. Physiol. USSR, 1940, 29: 144-50.—Usnadze, D. Zur Theorie der posthypnotisrhen Suggestion. Rapp. Congr. internat. psychol. (1937) 1938, 11. Congr., 477.—Volgyesi, F. Psycho- constitution et hypnophilie. Ibid., 484.—Wells, W. R. Ability to resist artificially induced dissociation. J. Abnorm. Psychol., 1940, 35: 261-72.—White, M. M. The physical and mental traits of individuals susceptible to hypnosis. Ibid., 1930-31, 25: 293-8.- White. R. W. 1'iodiction of hypnotic suscepti- bility from a knowledge of subjects' attitudes. .1. Psvchol.. Provincet., 1937, 3: 265-77. ------ Two types of hypnotic trance and their personality correlates. Ibid., 279 S9.------ An analysis of motivation in hypnosis. J. Gen. I'syehol., 1941, 24: 145-62. ------ A preface to the theory of hyp- notism. J. Abnorm. Psychol., 1941, 36: 477-505.—Wilson, S. R. The physiological basis of hypnosis and suggestion. Proc. R. Soc. M., Lond., 1920-27, 20: Sect. Anaesth., 15-21.— Young, P. ('. The nature of hypnosis; as indicated by the presence or absence of post-hvpnotic amnesia and rapport. J. Abnorm. Psychol., 1926-28, 22: 372-82. ---- Effects. Stein, T. *Ueber die hypnotische Beein- flussung des Blutzuckers, des Natrium- und Chlorgehaltes des Blutes [Basel] 26p. 8? S. Louis, 1929. Bakhtiarov, V. A. [Bruises from imaginary falls under hypnotic spell] Klin. J. Saratov, 1929, 6: 243-9.—Biasini, A. I lipoidi del sangue nella ipnoanestesia. Rass. clin. ter., 1932, 31: 297-305.— Birman, B. N., & Blumkina-Suslova, M. M. [Catatonic phenomena in hysterical and experimental hyp- nosis] Arkh. biol. nauk, 1935, 40: 245-51.—Bogolepov. N. K. [Hypnotism and the vegetative nervous svstem] Sovet. vrach. J., 1936, 1: 1082-8.—Caster. J. E., & Baker, G. S., jr. Com- parative suggestibility in the trance and waking states; a further study. J. Gen. Psychol., 1932, 7: 287-301.—Davis, R. C, & Kantor, J. R. Skin resistance during hypnotic states. Ibid., 1935, 13: 62-81.—Delhougne, F., & Hansen, K. Die suggestive Beeinflussbarkeit der Magen- und Pankreassekre- tion in der Hypnose. Deut. Arch. klin. Med., 1927, 157: 20-35.—Doupe, J., Miller, W. R., & Keller, W. K. Vasomotor reactions in the hypnotic state. J. Neur. Psvchiat., Lond., 1939, n. ser., 2: 97-106.—Erickson, M. H., & Erickson, E. M. The hypnotic induction of hallucinatory color vision followed by pseudo-negative after-images. J. Exp. Psychol., 1938, 22: 581-8. ------ Concerning the nature and character of post- hypnotic behavior. J. Gen. Psychol., 1911, 24: 95-133.— Fulde, E. Ueber den Einfluss hypnotischer Erregungszustande auf den Gasaustausch. Zschr. ges. Neur. Psychiat., 1937, 159: 761-6.—Gigon, A., Aigner, E., & Brauch, W. Ueber den Einfluss der Psyche auf korperliche Vorgiiiige; Hypnose und Blutzucker. Schweiz. med. Wschr., 1926, 56: 749.—Goldwyn, J. The effect of hypnosis on basal metabolism. Arch. Int. M., 1930, 45: 109-14.— Grassheim, K., & Wittkower, E. Ueber die suggestive Beeinflussbarkeit der spezifisch dyna- mischen Eiweisswirkung in Hypnose. Deut. med. Wschr., 1931, 57: 141-3.—Harriman, P. L. A note on an experimental investigation of the possible anti-social use of hypnosis; by M. H. Erickson. Psychiatry, 1941, 4: 187.—Hollander, B. Hypnosis and anaesthesia. Proc. R. Soc. M., Lond., 1932, 25: 597-610.—Ibragimbekov, F. A. [Hypnotic reactions| Nevro- pat. psikhiat., 1938, 7: No. 7-8, 89-93.—Jenness, A., & Hackman, R. C. Salivary secretion during hypnosis. J. Exp. Psychol., 1938, 22: 58-66.—Jenness, A., & Wible, C. L. Respiration and heart action in sleep and hypnosis. J. Gen. Psychol., 1937, 16: 197-222.—Kirschenberg. E. Die Verande- rungen der Blutviskositat wahrend der Hypnose. Fol. neuro- path, eston., 1925, 3:-4: 366-9.—Klemperer, E., & Weiss- mann, M. Beitrag zur somatischen Reaktionsweise Hypno- tisierter. Mschr. Psychiat., 1929, 71: 356-65.—Kretschmer, M., & Kriiger, R. Ueber die Beeinflussung des Serumkalkge- haltes in der Hypnose. Klin. Wschr., 1927, G: 09.5-7.— Levin, S. L. [Ueber die Besonderheiten der bedingten reflek- torischen Tatigkeit bei hypnotischen Zustanden beim Kinde] J. Physiol. USSR, 1934, 17: 196-206.------& Egolinsky, J. A. [Effect of the cerebral cortex on the course of energetic proc- esses; changes in gaseous metabolism during hypnotic sugges- tion of work] Ibid., 1930, 20: 979-92.—Levin, S. L., & Petrova, V. V. [Quantitative and biochemical changes in the secretion of the salivary glands during hypnosis] Klin, med., Moskva, 1938, 16: 738-43.—Levine, M. Electrical skin resistance during hypnosis. Arch. Neur. Psychiat., Chic, 1930, 24: 937-42. Also repr.—Liberson, G. J. [Vegetative reflexes in hypnotic conditions] J. nevropat. psikhiat., Moskva, 1929, 22: 189-93.—Loomis, A. L., Harvey, E. N., & Hobart. G. Brain potentials during hypnosis. Science, 1936, 83: 239-41.— Marcus, H., & Sahlgren, E. De Taction de la suggestion hypnotique sur les fonctions veg6tatives. Acta med. scand., 1926, Suppl., 16: 199-205. ------ Untersuchungen uber die Einwirkung der hypnotischen Suggestion auf die Funktionen des vegetativen Systemes. Acta psychiat. neur., Kbh., 1936, 11: 119-26.—Mowrer, O. H. A note on the effect of repeated hypnotic stimulation. J. Abnorm. Psychol., 1932, 27: 60-2.— Pap, Z. [Effect of mescaline upon posthypnotic hallucinations] Orv. hetil., 1936, 80: 75-8.—Pattie, F. A., jr. The production of blisters by hypnotic suggestion; a review. J. Abnorm. Psychol., 1941, 36: 62-72.—Russetzki, J. Sur les reflexes vegetatifs pendant le sornmeil hypnotique. Gaz. hop., 1930 103: 143.—Schazillo, B. A., & Abramov, N. P. Ueber die Wirkung der Hypnose auf das Verhaltnis d-r K- und Ca- Elektrolyte im Blutserum. Zschr. ges. Neur. I'-ychiat., 1928, 112: 54-9.—Sears, R. R. An experimental study of hypnotic anesthesia. J. Exp. Psychol., 1932, 15: 1-22.—Shaskan, D. Response of students to a demonstration of hypnotism. J. Gen. HYPNOSIS 957 HYPNOSIS Psychol., 1937, 17: 174-8.—Stalnaker, J. M., & Riddle E E The effect of hypnosis on long-delayed recall. Ibid 1932* 6- 429-40.—Stokvis, B. Etude de l'influence de l'hypnose sur la pression du sang, k l'aide d'une nouvelle methode d'enregistre- ment automatique ininterrompu. J. physiol path zin 1937 35: 691-700 -Tomescu, P., & Buc?ani, I. I. [Certain'physi- ological and psychological phenomena with suggestion of motion] Rev. st. med., Bucur., 1929, 18: 853-83.—Volgyesi F [Effects of hypnosis upon psychovegetative reflexes] Gv6- gyriszat, 1936, 76: 10; 27; 45; 53.-VoIevich. R. V. [Changes in handwriting in posthypnotic state] J. nevropat. psikhiat Moskva, 1931, 24: 61-8.-Welch, L. The space and time of induced hypnotic dreams. J. Psychol., Provincet., 1936, 1: 171-8.—Wells, F. L. Reaction time and allied measures under hypnosis; report of a case. J. Abnorm. Psychol., 1927-28 23- ' 264-75—Whitehorn, J. C, Lundholm, H., & Gardner, G. E Ihe metabolic rate in emotional moods induced by suggestion in hypnosis Am. J. Psychiat., 1929-30, 9: 661-6. Also N. England J. M., 1932, 206: 777-81. Also repr— Wieland E Einiges aus der letztjiihrigen Basler Poliomyelitisepidemie Schweiz. med. Wschr., 1938, 68: 753-7.—Williams, G. W The effect of hypnosis on muscular fatigue. J. Abnorm Psychol 1929-30, 24: 318-29.—Young, P. C. An experimental study of mental and physical functions in the normal and hypnotic states; additional results. Am. J. Psychol., 1926, 37: 345-56. —---- Hypnotic regression; fact or artifact? J. Abnorm. Psychol., 1940, 35: 273-8. ---- Forensic aspect. Jess [K. L.] H. *Verbrechen in Hypnose und posthypnotischer Suggestion [Kiel] 22p. 22cm. Wurzb., 1936. Mayer, L. Das Verbrechen in Hypnose und seine Aufklarungsmethoden. 221p. 8? Berl., 1937. Almeida, A. jr. Casamento sob hypnose. Arch. med. leg ident., Rio, 1936, No. 12, 335-44, 4 pl.— Billstrom, J. [Hyp- nosis in forensic medicine] Sven. lak. tidn., 1938, 35: 2019- 25.—Blum, E. Hypnose im Strafverfahren. Allg. Zschr. Psychiat., 1928, 89: 241-63.— Brennan, M. Experiments in the hypnotic production of anti-social and self-injurious be- havior. Psychiatry, 1942, 5: 49-61.—Burger-Prinz, H. Verbrechen in Hypnose? Fragen und Anmerkungen zu dem Buch von Ludwig Mayer, Verbrechen in Hypnose, 1937. Mschr. Kriminalb., 1938, 29: 194-8.—Csekey, L. [Medico- legal aspects of hypnosis] Orv. hetil., 1932, 76: [mell.] 66.— Erickson, M. H. Possible detrimental effects of experimental hypnosis. J. Abnorm. Psychol., 1933, 27: 321-7.------ An experimental investigation of the possible anti-social use of hypnosis. Psychiatry, 1939, 2: 391-414.—Ferruccio Falchi, G. Suggestione, ipnotismo e criminality. Scuola posit., 1933, n. ser-, 13: 492-514.—Gefahren (Die) offentlicher Vorfiih- rungen iiber Hypnotismus und Suggestion. Bull. Eidg. Ge- sundhamt., 1941, 537-9.—Haupt, J. Die Feststellung von Hypnose. Psychiat. neur. Wschr., 1928, 30: 19.—Heyer, G. R. Hypnose und Notzucht. Zschr. Sexwiss., 1928, 15: 1-8.— John, K. Zum Problem Hypnose und Verbrechen. Deut. Zschr. ges. gerichtl. Med., 1926-27, 9: 603-17.—Leroy, E. B. Escroqueries prolongees pendant plusieurs mois k l'aide de manoeuvres hypnotiques pratiquees sur une des victimes. C. rend. Congr. alien, neur. France (1907) 1908, 17. Congr., 124-34.—Meyer-Estorf. Verbrechen in Hypnose? Deut. Zschr. ges. gerichtl. Med., 1927-28, 11: 295-300.—Moreno, A. Interrogatorio judicial e hipnotismo. Rev. crim., B. Air., 1935, 22: 21-42.—Perlmutter, M. M. [Application of hypno- tism in legal medicine] J. nevropath. psykhiat., Moskva, 1928, 21: 691-700.—Schultz, I. H. Zur Psychologie der Gosund- heitsschadigungen nach Hypnose. Psychiat. neur. Wschr., 1933, 35: 616-8.—Steck, H. Enquete sur le danger des demon- strations publiques d'hypnotisme et de suggestion. Bull. Eidg. Gesundhamt., 1941, 500-4.—Things said under hypnosis or narcosis. Brit. M. J., 1942, 1: 94.—Tokarsky, B. A. [Diag- nosis of hypnotic states] Sovet. vrach. J., 1936, 1: 1789-96. --- Methods. Hollander, B. Methods and uses of hypnosis and self-hypnosis; a treatise on the powers of the subconscious mind. 191p. 12? Lond. [1935] Mayer, L. Die Technik der Hypnose; prak- tische Anleitung fiir Aerzte und Studierende. 193p. 8? Miinch., 1934. Narain, R. Medical hypnotism; its methods of practice and therapeutic application in disease. 176p. Delhi, 1909. Schultz, J. H. Hypnose-Technik; praktische Anleitung zum hypnotisieren fiir Aerzte. 80p. 8? Jena, 1935. Also 2. Aufl. 80p. 24^cm. Jena, 1939. Cass, W. A. An experimental investigation of the dissocia- tion hypothesis, utilizing a posthypnotic technique. Psychol. Bull., 1941, 38: 744.—Hauptmann, A. Versuche zur rascheren ?£rbeifuhrung einer Hypnose. Klin. Wschr., 1934, 13: ill w IY>\nw!,st. b/ hypnotics. Lancet, Lond., 1941, 1: «.m~N,arb"tov,ch- l- P. . [The possibility to produce hypno- a^JS?™\3hypnotl™tl™ 1!i man by means of neutral irritants according to the method of conditioned reflexes] Arkh. biol. nauk, 1934, 34: 1-14.-Neustatter, W. L. The technique of lain sHn InJ^ Early Treat" Nerv- Ment- Disord., Lond., $t^ r\°-TPeip^r' ^V Tlerische Hypnose am menschlichen Kinde Deut. med. Wschr., 1939, 65: 559-62.—Salter, A. f9,re|eteo^mTes ?!■ au£°hyPnosis. J. Gen. Psychol., 1941, 24: tli t?'J" i3ntatlfi'.h „E- „„ Su,la suggestione sperimentale. Fol med Nap., 1935 21: 731-42, pl.—Sarbin, T. R., & Madow, L. W. Predicting the depth of hypnosis by means of the Korschach test. Am. J. Orthopsychiat., 1942, 12: 208-70 — Schnorr von Carolsfeld, E. Zur Technik der arztlichen Hypnose. Psychiat. neur Wschr., 1932. 34: 277; 293.—Scott, H. D. r5?,1^0^ the conditioned reflex. J. Gen. Psychol., 1930. 4: 113-29.—Self hypnotism. J. Am. M. Ass., 1937, 109: 1136. ---- Therapeutic use. Bernheim, H. Suggestive therapeutics; a treatise on the nature and uses of hypnotism- transl. from the 2nd French ed. by Christian A Herter. 420p. 8? N. Y., 1899. Brotteaux, P. Hypnotisme et scopochlora- lose. 64p. 8? Par., 1936. Cannon, A. Hypnotism; suggestion and faith- healing. 43p. 8? Lond., 1932. Eckhard, H. *Hypnose und Suggestion in der Geburtshilfe und Gynakologie und deren neuer- hche Anwendung in der Universitats-Frauen- klinik zu Erlangen [Erlangen] 67p. 8? Kassel Heyer, G. Hypnosis and hypnotherapy. 12° Lond. [1931] Taplin, A. B. Hypnotism and treatment by suggestion. 4. ed. 135p. 16? Liverp., 1928. Ttjckey, C. L. Treatment by hypnotism and suggestion; or, Psychotherapeutics. 7. ed. 413p 8? Lond., 1921. Winkel, L. [L. J.] *Wesen und Bedeutung der therapeutischen Hypnose speciell bei Psy- chosen. 38p. 8? Bonn, 1930. Connellan, P. S. The treatment of repressed memories by hypnotism. Bristol Med. Chir. J., 1926, 43: 209-16.—Connely, E. The uses of hypnosis in psychotherapy. N. Orleans M. & S. J., 1935-36, 88: 627-32.—Copeland, C. L., & Hitching, E. H. Hypnosis in mental hospital practice. J. Ment. Sc, Lond., 1937, 83: 316-29.—Crocq. Un miracle scientifique. Progr' med. beige, 1912,14: 161-6.—Dattner, B., & John, E. Kritische Bemerkungen zur Frage der Beeinflussung organischer Storun- gen durch Suggestion, Hypnose und Schlafmittelhypnose Zschr. ges. Neur. Psychiat., 1925-26, 100: 639-51.—Dubnikov, E. I. [Treatment by hypnosis] Vrach. gaz., 1926, 30: 1068-73. ------ [Hypnotherapy in practice] Sovet. vrach. J., 1939, 43: 110-9.—Erickson, M. H. The applications of hypnosis to psychiatry. Med. Rec, N. Y., 1939, 150: 60-5.—Eysenck, H. J. An experimental study of the improvement of mental and" physical functions in the hypnotic state. Brit. J. M. Psychol., 1941, 18: 304-16.—Exner, H. V. Auto-suggestion and hypnosis in general practice. S. Afr. M. J., 1933, 7: 171-5.—Gerenstein, G. B. [Hypnosis in obstetrics and gynecology] J. akush zhensk. bolez., 1924, 35: No. 3, 235-40.—Jaastad, L. B. Hyp- nosis; an adjunct to therapy. Marquette M. Rev., 1937-39, 2: 142-7.—Koster, S. [Application of hypnosis in organic diseases] Psychiat. neur. bl., Amst., 1937, 41: 138-65, 2 pl.— Krylov, T. K. [Use of hypnosis in the surgery of the eye] Tr. Vseross. sezd. glas. vrach., 1929, 1: 219-25.—Langsner, A. M. Suggestao e hypnotismo. Brasil med., 1936, 50: 976-81.— Lazersonas, V. [Methods in therapeutic hypnosis] Medicina Kaunas, 1940, 21: 999-1003.—Lehoczky, T. [Indications of hypnosis] Orv. hetil., 1936, 80: mell., 1.—Levbarg, J. J. Hypnosis; a potent therapy in medicine. N. York Physician, 1940, 14: 18.—Livingood, F. G. Hypnosis as an aid to adjust- ment. J. Psychol., Provincet., 1941, 12: 203-7.—McCartney, J. L. Psychotherapy, with special reference to the use of hypnosis. Ann. Int. M., 1938-39, 12: 1279-94.—Mayer, E. Ueber Hypnose in der Orthopadie. Verh. Deut. orthop. Ges. (1926) 1927, 21. Congr., 387-92.—Miranda, I. de. M. O hipnotismo e o seu valor na clinica como agente terapeutico. Arq. Esc. med. cir. Nova Goa., 1928, ser. B, 210-23.—Molen- graft, C. J., & Kimble, H. E. Sedation and hypnosis with minimal side reactions. Illinois M. J., 1941, 79: 432-4.— Osipov, N. [Value of hypnotism in medicine] Rev. neur. psychiat., Praha, 1929, 26: 177-80— Paramonov, V. A. [Use of hypnosis in surgery] Khirurgia, Moskva, 1937, No. 12, 15- 8.—Protopopov, I. [Adoption of hypnosis in sanatorium sur- roundings] Vrach. delo, 1928, 11: 733.—Raeder, O. J. Hyp- nosis and allied forms of suggestion in practical psychotherapy. Am. J. Psychiat., 1933, 13: 69-76.—Reistrup, H. [Historical HYPNOSIS 958 HYPNOTIC development of hypnotherap}' and the present methods] I'geskr. laeger, 1938, 100: 29-36.—Staudacher, C. Neue Wege der Hvpnosebehandlung. Ber. Allg. iirztl. Kongr. Psychother., 1927, 2. Congr., 304-10.—Stokvis, B. Der houtige Stand der Indikationen der Hypnose. Schweiz. med. Wschr., 1938, 68: 1252-5. ------ Die Autohypnose als psychotherapeutisches Hilfsmittel. Mschr. Psychiat., 1939, 101: 4-7.—Sviadoshch, A. M. [Hypnosis in pre- and post- operative periods] Ortop. travmat., 1938, 12: No. 5, 71-7.— Taylor. J. M. What hypnosis is, its uses for extremes of ner- vousness or anxiety psychosis, with special reference to bone conduction as a cause. Med. Rev. of Rev., N. Y., 1926, 32: 393-5.—Travell, J. Some recent advances in hypnosis and sedation. Med. Clin. N. America, 1940, 24: 603-11.—Vallejo Najera, A. De la hipnosis y de la hipnoterapia: concepto, tecnica y aplicaciones del hipnotismo. Siglo med., 1926, 77: 534-9.—Vincze, A. Hypnotische Beeinflussung einer organi- schen Erkrankung. Psychiat. neur. Wschr., 1934, 36: 460.— Volgyesi, F. Beeinflussungen der vegetativen Reflexe und der sogenannten autonomen Organfunktionen durch Hypnose- therapie. Proc. Internat. Physiol. Congr. (1935) 1938, 15. Congr., 99.—Wagnerova, H., & Prokop, J. [Hypnotism in the treatment of mental diseases] Bratisl. lek. listy, 1930, 10: 226—43.—Wittkower, E. Mastkur in Hvpnose. Psychother. Prax., Wien, 1934, 1: 214.—Wookey, E. E. Uses and limita- tions of hypnosis in dental treatment. Brit. Dent. J., 1938, 65: 562-8.—Zarchi, I. [Concerning 2 cases cured by hypnosis] Vrach. gaz., 1927, 31: 1677-9.—Zeligs, M. A. Hypnosis. Ohio M. J., 1938, 34: 638-43. ---- in animals. Erhard, H. Hypnose bei Tieren. 32p. 8? Giessen, 1924. Beritov, J. Ueber die Entstehung der tierischen Hypnose. Zschr. Biol., 1929, 89: 77-82.-£-Bonnet, V., & Saboul, R. Contribution k l'etude de l'hypnose animale. J. physiol. path. gen., Par., 1935, 33: 887-906.—Pavlov, I. P. A contribution to the physiology of the hypnotic state of dogs. Character & Personality, 1934, 2: 189-200. Also in his Condit. Reflex. & Psychiat., N. Y., 1941, 2: 75-82.—Pressman, A. P. [Investiga- tions on experimentum mirabile in birds] Arkh. biol. nauk, 1936, 42: 205-11.—Keisinger, L. Hypnose der Vogel. Zool. Anz., 1926, 66: 227-30. ------ Hvpnose des Steinkauzes. Biol. Zbl., 1926, 46: 630. ------ Hvpnose des Flusskrebses. Ibid., 1927, 47: 722-6. ------ Hypnose der Vogel. Ibid., 1932, 52: 420-9.—Rijlant, P. Le tonus musculaire chez un mammifere en etat d'hypnose. C. rend. Soc. biol., 1933, 113: 421-4.—Steiniger, F. Neue Beobachtungen uber Reaktions- hemmung (sogenannten (tierische Hypnose) bei Vogeln. Biol. Zbl., 1936, 56: 116-47. ------ Die Biologie der sogenannten tierischen Hypnose. Erg. Biol., 1936, 13: 348-451.—Stroder, J. Leber den Einfluss der tierischen Hypnose auf den Ablauf der Narkose beim Kaltbliiter. Schmerz, 1939-40, 12: 86.— Ten Gate, J. [Phenomena of so-called animal hypnosis in Raja clavata] Ned. tschr. geneesk., 1927, 71: pt 1, 968-70. ■---— Zur Frage nach dem Entstehen der Zustande der sogenannten tierischen Hypnose. Biol. Zbl., 1928, 48: 664-79. ------ Nouvelles observations sur l'hypnose dite animale; 6tat d'hvpnose chez Octopus vulgaris. Arch, neerl. physiol., 1928-29] 13: 402-6.—Tonkikh, A. V. The participation of the autonomic nervous svstem in so-called animal hypnosis. Proc. Internat. Physiol. Congr. (1935) 1938, 15. Congr., 111.— Usievich, M. A. [Xew functional method of control of the developing hypnotic state in the dog] Tr. Fiziol. lab. Pavlova, 1940, 9: 137-17.—Warnke, G. Akinese und Druckinstinkt bei der Waldschnepfe. Biol. Zbl., 1941, 61: 162-82. HYPNOTIC. See also Sedative; also under proper names of hypnotic substances. See also Sleep, Disorder. Bernd, H. *Eine Prufung der Schlafmittel Phanodorm, Evipan, Profundol und Pulipan [Bonn] 59p. 8! Wiirzb., 1938. Tamm, W. *Dormalgin und andere Nervina. 23p. 8? Freib. i. B., 1933. Wachter, H. *Objektive Schlafmittelprufung. 28p. 8? Erlangen, 1936. Barr, D. P. Drugs for the relief of pain: analgesic and narcotic drugs. In his Modern Med. Ther., Bait., 1940, 1: 30—41.—Beaudouin, H. A propos de la deiivrance des medica- ments hypnotiaues. Ann. med. psychol., Par., 1926, 84: pt 1, 459-61.—Browning, C. Hypnotics and analgesics. Tr. Med. Chir. Soc. Glasgow, 1935-36, 30:145.—Castled en, L. I. M. Hypnotic drugs. Practitioner, Lond., 1936, 137:358-68.— Craig, M. Drugs for sleeplessness. Brit. M. J., 1927, 1: 983.—Darmstaedter, E. Anfange und Entwicklungslinien der modernen Schlafmittel. Schmerz, 1934-35, 7: 101-11.— David, J. C. On hypnotics. Madras M. J., 1936, 16: 81-92.— Filomeni, M. I farmaci addorme ntanti; rassegna di aggiorna- mento. Minerva med., Tor., 1940, 31: 31-7 (microfilm)— Hamill, P. Hypnotics, sedatives, and anaesthetics. In Brit. Encycl. M. Pract. (Rolleston, H.) 1939, Surveys, 163.— Hapkc. Das Beruhigungs- und Einschliiferungsmittel Valamin. Med. Klin., Berl., 1918, 14: 1042.—Haynes. G. S. Hypnotic drugs. Med. Press & Cue, Dubl., 1935, 190: 598. Hjort, A. M. Hvpnotikon. In Med. Papers (H. A. < btislian Anniv. vol.) Bost., 1936, 903-17.—[Kvietnl; hypnotic soinnifacieiit] Sovet. med., 1939, No. 5, 61.— LefTkowitz. M. Ein Essig- siiurcamid (Novonal) als Schlafmittel. Ther. Gegenwart, 1928, 69: 60-62.— Leinzinger, M. On a new hypnotic. Magy. orv. areh., 1935, 36: 195-8.—Loeper, M. Les hvpnotiques. In Ther. med. (Loeper, M.) Par., 1935, 8: 47-63.— Lumidre, A., & Perrin, F. Sur une nouvelle clnssc d'hypnotiques: les dialcoylphenylacetaroides. C. rend. Acad, sc, 1920, 183: 617.— McNiven.A. A discussion on hypnotics and analgesics. Tr. Med. Chir. Soc. Glasgow, 1935-36, 30: 012 71.- Meyer, H. H. Altes und Neues iiber Schlaf und Narkose. Wien. klin. Wschr., 1937, 50: 757-9 —M0ller, K. O. [A new hypnotic, novonal] Ugesk. larger, 1929, 91: 547.— Offergeld, H. Aethe- rische Oele als Schlafmittel. Deut. Aerzte Ztg, 1935, No. 421.— Parsons, F. B. Hypnotic drugs. Med. Press & Circ, Dubl., 1935, 190: 599-601—Pick, E. P. Ueber Schlaf und Schlaf- mittel. Wien. klin. Wschr., 1927, 40: 0.34-6.—Pilcz. A. Ueber Schlafmittel. Ibid., 1930, 43: 1377-80.—Ravn, J. [Somni- facients] Ugeskr. laeger, 1937, 99: 1311-6.—Schass, E. U. [Somnifacients and sedatives] Feldsher, Moskva, 1938, No. 11, 49-52.—Schwartz, A. Le sornmeil et les hypnotiques. In Probl. physiopath. (Ambard-Ancel) Par., 1939, 3. ser., 91-122.—Stevenson, D. S. A discussion on hypnotics and analgesics. Tr. Med. Chir. Soc. Glasgow, 1935-36, 30: 146- 61.—Taubmann, G. Schlafmittel; Theorelisebes und Prak- tisches. Med. Klin., Berl., 1935, 31: 136-40—Tiffeneau, P. Les nouveaux hvpnotiques. In Lecons du dimanche (Carnot, P.) Par., 1930, 2. ser., 227-58.—Wimplinger, F. Novonal, ein neues Schlafmittel. Deut. med. Wschr., 1928, 54: 311.— Zuelzer, G. Ueber Dormen, ein neues Schlafmittel. Med. Klin., Berl., 1930, 26: 20. ---- Chemistry. Baumgart, E. *Die Wirkungssteigerung der Schlafmittel durch Analgetica. 18p. 8? Bresl., 1932. Brinkamp, B. * Vergleichende Untersuchun- gen iiber den Einfluss von Veronal, Phanodorm, Evipan, Luminal und Prominal auf den Zucker- abbau durch tierisches Gewebe [Munster] 15p. 8? Werne-Lippe, 1934. Brinkmann, H. *Der Vergleich der schmerz- stillenden Wirkung der Komplexverbindung Veronalstrontium-Pyramidon mit ihren Grund- stoffen [Munster] 28p. 8? Werne-Lippe, 1934. Elcer, W. *Ueber den Einfluss verschiedener Hypnotika auf den Sauerstoffverbrauch [Mun- ster] 16p. 8? Duisb.-Meiderich, 1932. Fronius, H. *Weckversuche mit analepti- schen Kombinationen [Tubingen] 51p. 22cm. Sibiu-Hermannstadt, 1938. Hatjmann, H. *Ueber den Einfluss von Sehlafmitteln auf die alkoholische Garung [Mun- ster] 17p. 21>£cm. Dortmund-Mengede, 1936. Kramer, F. *Ueber die schmerzstillende Wirkung einiger Hypnotika [Munster] 40p. 8? Werne-Lippe, 1934. Kranke, H. *Ueber den Einfluss von Hypno- tika auf Temperatur und Peristaltik [Leipzig] 23p. 23^cm. [Zeulenroda i. Thur.] 1936. Krtjll, K. J. *Die schmerzstillende Wirkung verschiedener Hypnotika [Munster] 25p. 8? Hamm (Westf.) 1935. Nietschmann, A. [A. O.] *Ueber die Wirkung von Veronal-Pyiamidongemischen bei verschie- dener Applikationsart. 17p. 23cm. Halle (Saale) 1936. Schwerdtleger, T. *Ueber den Einfluss der Hypnotika auf die Eiweissverdauung [Munster] 19p. 21cm. Werne a. d. Lippe, 1936. Ehrhart, G. The hypnophore groups. In Med. in its chem. aspects, 1934, 2: 338-45.—Miller, C. O. The asymmetry of certain hypnotics and its relationship to physiological behavior. Abstr. Theses Univ. Chicago, 1926-27, 5: 205-10.—PfeifTer, P., & Seydel, R. Zur Konstitution des Hypnals und Trigemins. Zschr. physiol. Chem., 1928, 178: 97-108.—Preiswerk, E. Schlafmittelsynthese. In Festschrift E. C. Barell, Basel, 1936, 185-94.—Weese, H. From the evolution of the syn- thesis of hypnotics. In Med. Chem, Aspects, 1933, 175-82. HYPNOTIC 959 HYPNOTIC ---- Pharmacodynamics. Adler, P., & Hradecky, C. Die Galvanonarkose als Priif- mittel fiir den Wirkungsverlauf von Hypnoticis und Narcoticis beim Frosch. Arch. exp. Path., Berl., 1936, 181: 541-52. ------ Vergleich chemisch identischer Schlafmittel mit Hilfe der Galvanonarkose im Froschversuch. Klin Wschr 1937, 16: 519-22—Aebi, M. E. Ueber die Wirkung der Kombination von Veronal-Natrium, Laktophenin und Codein. Ausz. Inaugur. Diss. Med. Fak. Univ. Bern (1931-33) 1934J No. 57, 1.—Agnoli, R. Influenza esercitata da spostamenti sperimentali neU'equilibrio acido-base suU'azione di varie sostanze ipnotiche. Arch. ital. sc. farm., 1934, 3: 403-46.— Bauer, R. Steigerung der Vertraglichkeit und Wirksamkeit von Schmerz- und Schlafmitteln. Praxis, Bern, 1939, 28: 71.—Bayer, L. Anasthesie als Heilmittel (zugleich eine er- ganzende Bemerkung zur Arbeit von Stejskal) Med Klin Berl., 1939, 35: 675-8 [Schlusswort von K. Stejskal] 679.— Borbely, F. Ueber intrazisternale Schlafmittelwirkung Arch exp. Path., Berl., 1935, 179: 483-97.—Burtner, R. R., & Leh- mann, G. The hypnotic properties of some derivatives of trihalogenated alcohols. J. Pharm. Exp. Ther., 1938, 63: 183-92.—Butturini, L. Sull'assorbimento di taluni ipnotici nello stomaco. Boll. Soc. ital. biol. sper., 1933, 8: 836-9 Also Boll. Soc. med. chir. Pavia, 1933, 47: 1043-9.—Dost, H. Zur Physiologie und Pharmakologie des Schlafes; vegetative Gifte und ihre Schlafwirkung. Arch. exp. Path., Berl 1934 176: 478-85.—Ehrhart, G. O grupo hipn6foro. Farm, brasil ' 1937, 12: No. 46, 17-21.—Friedemann, A. Klinische ver- gleichende Untersuchungen zur individuellen Reaktion auf Schlafmittel bei oraler und rektaler Darreichung. Deut. med Wschr., 1930, 56: 807-70.— Fromherz, K. Peripher lahmende Wirkungen von Schlafmitteln, besonders der Gruppe der Amide und Ureide. Arch. exp. Path., Berl., 1933, 173: 78-85.— Fuchs, H. J. Ueber die Summation der Wirkung zweier Schlafmittel durch ihre molekulare Vereinigung. Ibid., 1936, 181: 215-8.—Fuhry, H. Klinische Untersuchungen iiber ein neues Schlafmittel. Deut. med. Wschr., 1934, 60: 754.— Giordano, G. B. Ricerche sulle mioclone ipniche fisiologiche nei sonno provocato da ipnotici. Boll. Soc. ital. biol. sper., 1938, 13: 821. Also Riv. sper. freniat., 1938, 62: 680-94 — Girndt, O. Die Ermittlung der Wirkungsstarke von Schlaf- mitteln und Schlafmittel-Kombinationen mit Hilfe der Lage- und Bewegungs-Reaktionen. Schmerz, 1930-31, 3: 81-5. ------ & Huhn, O. Zur Frage der Beeinflussung der Schlaf- mittelwirkung durch Antipyretica. Arch. exp. Path., Berl., 1936, 183: 236-55.—Graf. O. Ueber die Bestimmung der Wirkungsstarke von Schlafmitteln durch den psychologischen Tagesversuch. Munch, med. Wschr., 1928, 75: 2171.— Griininger, U. Untersuchungen iiber die Schlafmittelver- triiglichkeit im Kindesalter. Mschr. Kinderh., 1938, 75: 50-4.—Gutschmidt, J. Chemisch-physiologische Untersuchun- gen iiber die Abbaufahigkeit des Dormovits. Klin. Wschr., 1940, 19: 296-9 (microfilm)—Hermann, S. Die Anwendung des Tempierungsprinzipes zur Verlangerung der Wirkungs- dauer der Schlafmittel. Ibid., 1933, 12: 1689.—Hesse, E., Baumgart, E., & Dickmann, H. Zur Wirkungssteigerung der Schlafmittel durch Analgetica. Ibid., 1932, 11: 1665 — Hjort, A. M., deBeer, E. J., & Fassett, D. W. The effect of the diet upon the anesthetic qualities of some hypnotics. J. Pharm. Exp. Ther., 1939, 65: 79-88. ------ The hypnotic effect of repeated injections of unsymmetrical ethyl-o-ethylphenylurea in albino rats and the influence of sex thereon. Ibid., 1940, 68: 62-8.—Hofmann, H. Die Wirkung einiger Schlafmittel auf den Blutdruck. Arch. exp. Path., Berl., 1936, 183: 127-37. ------ Beeinflussung des Blutdrucks durch Cardiazol und Ephedrin an Tieren, die mit Schlafmitteln vorbehandelt wurden. Ibid., 146-58.—Hondelink, H. Schlafmittelversuche an Finken. Ibid., 1931-32, 163: 662-71. ------ Weitere Mitteilungen iiber Verefuche mit Schlafmitteln an Finken. Acta brevia neerl., 1932, 2: 143.—Horsley, J. S. Narco- analysis. J. Ment. Sc, Lond., 1936, 82: 416-22.—Hundt, H. Fineural in der Nervenpraxis. Deut. med. Wschr., 1936, 62: 1176.—Isimaru, S. Ueber die Wirkung einiger Hypnotica auf Blutzucker, Blutmilchsaure und Blutalkalireserve des Kanin- chens. Mitt. Med. Akad. Kioto, 1938, 23: 1085.—Itkin, Z. M. [Antagonism between somnifacients of the aliphatic series and nicotine] Farm. & toks., Moskva, 1939, 2: No. 5, 38-50.— ltd, K. Vergleichende Studien uber die pharmakologische Wirkung des Bromalhydrats und Chloralhydrats. Fol. jap. pharm., 1926, 2: [Brev.l 13.—Karcher, M. Nervenberuhigung und Schlaferzeugung. Deut. Aerzte Ztg, 1936, 11: No. 430.— Keeser, E. Zur Pharmakologie der Hypnotika. Deut. med. Wschr., 1928,54: 650.—Klimesch, K. Ueber die Ursachen der verschieden langen Intervalle zwischen intravendser Injektion und Wirkung von Schlafmitteln. Arch. exp. Path., Berl., 1933, 172: 10-7.—Kobayashi, Y. The influence of hypnotica on the electrocardiogram. Acta Scholae med. Univ. Kioto, 1931-32, 14: 365-73.—Kohn, R., & Jacobi, M. Untersuchun- gen iiber qualitative und quantitative Beziehungen zwischen Schlafmitteln und Analepticis. Arch. exp. Path., Berl., 1935, 179: 448-58.—Kramer, E. Erfahrungen mit Avedorm, einem Schlafmittel pflanzlicher Zusammensetzung. Psychiat. neur. Wschr., 1938, 40: 393. ------ Neue Erfahrungen mit Avedorm. Ibid., 1939, 41: 61. ------ & Varga, T. Unter- suchungen zur Pharmakologie und Pharmakodynamie des Kindesalters; Sohlafmittel. Arch. Kinderh., 1936, 109: 7-20.— La Mendola, S. Azione degli ipnotici sui lipoidi cerebrali. Arch. farm, sper., Roma, 1924, 38: 32-45.—Lazarew, M. Ueber die perkutane Resorption von Schlafmitteln. Arch. exp. Path., Berl., 1932, 168: 162-70.—L6vy, J. Etude de 1 action de quelques hypnotiques sur diverses especes de poissons de mer. C. rend. Soc. biol., 1927, 97: 1226.—Liaci, L. Azione di alcune sostanze ipnotiche sull'attivita del tessuto muscolare. Rass. fisiopat., 1937, 9: 653-69.—Maloney, A. H. A comparison of the subjective effects of hypnotic doses bromural, evipal and ortal. J. Nat. M. Ass., 1936, 28: 99-102.—Mehes, J. Studien uber den Angriffspunkt von Schlafmitteln. Wien. klin. Wschr., 1926, 39: 962.—Molitor, H., & Pick, E. P. Ver- starkte Schlafmittelwirkung durch gleichzeitige Beeinflussung verschiedener Hirnteile. Arch. exo. Path., Lpz., 1926, 115: 318-27.—Nelson, J. W., Lyster, S. C, & Cartland, G. F. A pharmacological study of some new synthetic hypnotics. J. Am. Pharm. Ass., 1941, 30: 180-2.—Olszycka, L. Etude quantitative des phenom^nes de synergie; potentialisation de Taction hypnotique chez la souris. C. rend. Acad, sc, 1935, 201: 796. ------ Sur quelques associations d'hypnotiques; exaltation de Taction anesthesique. C. rend. Soc. biol., 1939, 130: 1244-6.—Pick, E. P. Ueber Aenderung energetischer Vorgiinge im Gehirn durch Schlaf- und Erregungsmittel und deren ortliche Begrenzung. Klin. Wschr., 1937, 16: 1481-6. ------ The site of action of hypnotics and analeptics in the brain. J. Mount Sinai Hosp. N. York, 1940-41, 7: 609-18.— Pinkhof, J. [Rate of elimination of some sleep-producing agents] Ned. tschr. geneesk., 1930, 74: pt 1, 2991-3004.— Piotrowski, G. Duree d'action des somniferes et tension partielle d'oxygene de Tair inspire. Schweiz. med. Wschr., 1937, 67: 671.—Platonova-Petrovskaia, A. F. [On the com- bined effect of somnifacients; barbiturics, antipyretics and salts of magnesia] Radianska med., 1939, 4: No. 5-6, 41-6.— Rabbeno, A., & Ruffini, V. L'attivit& comparata degli ipnotici studiata sul preparato anteriore di rana. Boll. Soc eustach., 1933, 31: 105-17.—Regelsberger, H. Ueber Schlaftiefenbe- stimmungen und Schlafmittelpriifung. Verh. Deut. Ges. inn. Med., 1938, 50. Kongr., 571-3.—Rose, H., & Peters, H. Ueber ein neues Schlafmittel: Pheninox. Med. Welt, 1935, 9: 1739.—Rosenthal, F., & Wallach, G. Ueber den Einfluss der Schlafmittel auf Pikrotoxin, ein Beitrag zur Frage des Kiihl- zentrums. Arch. exp. Path., Berl., 1936, 181: 219-32.— Schmidt, M. [Somnifacients with special regard to combina- tions of somnifacients] Ugeksr. losger, 1931, 93: 962-5.— Sellei, C, & Mayer, G. Ueber die Wirkung der Schlafmittel. Arch. exp. Path., Lpz., 1937-38, 188: 699-713. Also Magy. orv. arch., 1939, 40: 9-19.—Sibuya, H. Einfluss der Schlaf- mittel und einigen zentral wirkenden Gifte (Naphthylamin und Pikrotoxin) auf die Wiederherstellung des Bluteiweisses sowie dessen kolloidosmotischen Drucks nach Plasmapheresis. Tohoku J. Exp. M., 1939, 35: 123-43.—Steinmetzer, K. Versuche mit Schlafmittelkombinationen. Arch. exp. Path., Lpz., 1928, 132: 172-92.------Verstiirkung der Schlaf- mittelwirkung durch Antipyretika. Ibid., 135: 198-209.— Stoughton, R. W., & Baxter, J. H., jr. Hypnotic action of 5,5-dialkyl-2,4-oxazolidincdiones with special reference to 5,5-di-n-propyl-2,4-oxazolidinedione. J. Pharm. Exp. Ther., 1941, 73: 45-50.—Takenaka, S. Investigation of the influence of hypnotica upon the electrocardiogram. Acta Schote med. Univ. Kioto, 1931-32, 14: 337-44— Tod, H. Studies on carbo- hydrate metabolism in nervous and mental disorders; the disturbance of the glucose tolerance test caused by hypnotics in clinical doses. Edinburgh M. J., 1937, 44: 416-20.—Trois observations typiques d'efficacite de certains hypnotiques. Rev. med. est, 1934, 62: 461.—Urban, H. Ueber die Wirkung von Schlafmitteln am Menschen bei direkter Einbringung in den Liquor cerebrospinalis mittels Suboccipital-Stich. Arch. exp. Path., BerL, 1935, 179: 498-503.—Velluz, L. Contribution k l'etude de la narcose: sur le coefficient de partage des hypno- tiques entre Teau et les dissolvants organiques et particuliere- ment avec les dissolvants possedant des liaisons ethyieniques. Bull. Soc. chim. biol., Par., 1926, 8: 751-64.—Weese, H. Moderne Schlafmitteltnerapie und Basisnarkose. Arch. exp. Path., Berl., 1936, 181: 46-61.—Werz, R. von, & Verleger, R. Ein einfaches Verfahren der zahlenmassigen Bewertung seda- tiver Effekte. Ibid., 1939, 192: 292-9.—Wuth, O. Tierexperi- mentelle Untersuchungen iiber physiologische Wirkungen einiger Schlafmittel. Nervenarzt, 1930, 3: 591-4.—Ziegelroth, L. Ueber Erfahrungen mit dem neuen Schlafmittel Profundol in der Anstaltspraxis. Psychiat. neur. Wschr., 1936, 38: 575-9. ---- Poisoning. Pohlisch, K., & Panse, F. Schlafmittelmiss- brauch. 170p. 8? Lpz., 1934. Also Psychiat. neur. Wschr., 1934, 36: 289-91. Schmidt, A. *SchIafmittelvergiftungen [Hei- delberg] 15p. 22cm. Hamb., 1938. Steidel, T. *Der Krankheitsverlauf bei Schlafmittelvergiftungen [Heidelberg] 23p. 22cm. Diisseld., 1938. Steinbacher, M. *Vergiftungen durch Schlaf- mittel in der Nachkriegszeit. 28p. 8? Wiirzb., 1933. Abuse (The) of hypnotics. J. Am. M. Ass., 1939, 113: 1748.—Aizawa, T. Isoelektrischer Punkt der Gehirnzellen bei der Schlafmittelvergiftung. Jap. J. M. Sc, Soc. Med. & HYPNOTIC 960 HYPNOTIC Hyg.. 1939-40, 3: Proc, 19; 192—Balazs, G. [Treatment of poisoning by hypnotics] Orv. hetil., 1937, 81: [mell.] 5.— Becker, W. Schlafmittelmissbrauch und seine rechtlichen Folgen. Med. Welt, 1941, 15: 379-81.—Bering, F. Ueber Schlafmittelexantheme. .Derm. Wschr., 1936, 103: 1556. Also Munch, med. Wschr., 1936, 83: 1510-2. Also Zbl. Haut Geschlkr., 1936, 54: 566.—Bienkowsky, P. Ueber Berufs- schadigungen der Atmungsorgane; eine Klar- und Richtigstel- lung zu dem Artikel von Sylla: Berufsschadigungen der At- mungsorgane. Med. Klin., lierl.. 1939. 35: 679.—Birnbaum, K. Nutzen und Schaden der Schhil'inittel. Zschr. iirztl. Fortbild., 1929, 26: 244-6.—Brasher, ('. W. J. The use and abuse of hypnotics. Practitioner, Lond., 1927, 119: 308-13.—Di Prisco. Gli ipnotici: usi e pericoli. Morgagni, 1934, 76: 177.—Dona- telli, L. A riguardo della diagnosi differenziale tra gli avvelena- menti da ipnotici; su di un particolare sintomo utilizzabile nella diagnosi clinica del barbiturismo acuto. Minerva med., Tor., 1937, 28: pt 2, 198-203.—Ebes, A. J. H. Experimenteller Beitrag zur Behandlung der akuten Schlafmittelvergiftung mit todlicher Dosis. Acta brevia neerl., 1939, 9: 137-40.—Ein- hauser, M. Giftwirkung der Schlafmittel und Nebennieren- rinde. Klin. Wschr., 1939, 18: 423-7.- Fischer, H. Ueber die akute Schlafmittelveigiftung und ihre Theiapie. Schweiz. med. Wschr., 19.35, 65: 111 Ii. Fischer, R. Der toxikologische Nachweis von Schlafmitteln. Arch, l'lmrm., Berl.. 1939, 277: 305-21.—Flury, F. Sdikifuul telmissl,ranch. Deut. med. Wschr., 1934, 60: 1155-8.—Gelma, E. T*s phenomfines d'intoxication provoques par certains hypnotiques administres k dose therapeutique ou meme a faible dose. Strasbourg med., 1926, 84: pt 2. 119-21.— Gierlich, H. Die Weckwirkung des Thujons bei Schlafmittelvcrgiftungen. Arch. exp. Path., Lpz., 1937, 187: 129-40—Heinrich, A. Zur Therapie der Schlaf- mittelvergiftungen; zugleich ein Beitrag zur Frage der Wirkung hoher intravendser Caidiazolgaben. Klin. Wschr.. 1939, 18: 1410-6.—Henrich, H. Coramin bei Schlafmittelvergiftung. Munch, med. Wschr., 1933, 80: 526.—Holzer, F. J. I.eichen- befundo nach Schlafmittelvergiftung. Deut. Zschr. gerichtl. Med., 1940, 34: 307-21 (microfilm)—Hypnotic drugs other than alkaloids. Lancet, Lond., 1933, 2: 1425-7.—Ishibashi, N. Ueber die histopathologischen Veranderungen des Zentral- nervensystems bei experimentellen Schlafmittelvergiftungen. Psychiat. neur. jap., 1940, 44: 45.—Knospe, H. Schlafmittel- missbrauch. Oeff. Gesundhdienst, 1937-38, 3: B, 381-4.— Krautwald, A. Hohe intravenose Cardiazolgaben bei Schlaf- mittelvergiftungen. Klin. Wschr., 1911, 20: 94.—Lange, J., & Guttmann, E. Zur Diagnose der Schlafmittel-Vergiftungen. II.ill.. 1920, 5: 1686.—Laubcnder, W., & Monden, K. Experi- mentelle chronische Schlafmittelvergiftung und Porphyrinurie. Arch. exp. Path., Lpz., 1937-38, 188: 562-79.—Likier, A. [Use of large doses of coramin and stiminol in acute poisoning by morphine, veronal and other hypnotics] Polsk. arch. med. wewn., 1934, 12: 135^7. Maurer, H. Schlafmittelmissbrauch in betriigerischer Absicht. Dent. med. Wsehr., 1940, 66: 854-7.—Meerloo, A. M. (Danger in sale of somnifacients] Ned. tschr. geneesk., 1937, 81: 49S0 —Minehart, J. R. The promiscuous sale of hypnotics. Atlantic M. J.. 1927-28, 31: 9. Misuse (The) of hypnotics. .1. Am. M. Ass., 1937, 108: 1903.—Morchen, F. Die Schlaf mittelfrage. Deut. med. Wschr., 1934, 60: 798-800.—Morimune, M. Klinische und experimentelle Studien iiber die akute Schlafmittelvergiftung; iiber den Lipoidstoffwechsel im Blute bei akuter Schlafmittel- vergiftung. Mitt. Med. Akad. Kioto, 1936, 16: 697.------ Klinische und experimentelle Studien iiber die akute Schlaf- mittelvergiftung; iiber den Phosphatstoffwechsel im Blute bei akuter Schlafmittelvergiftung. Ibid., 699.------Klinische und experimentelle Studien iiber die akute Schlafmittelvergif- tung; Einfluss von Pyridin-/3-carbonsauredia,thylamid (25%) auf den Blutzucker und die Phosphatfraktionen im Blute bei akuter Calmotinvergiftung. Ibid., 701.—Mott, F. W., Wood- house, D. L., & Pickworth, F. A. The pathological effects of hypnotic drugs upon the central nervous system of animals. Brit. J. Exp. Path., 1926-27, 7: 325-3.6, pl.—Oettel, H. Schlaf- mittelbestimmung im Harn, insbesondere bei Schlafmittel- suchtigen. Klin. Wschr., 1936, 15: 733. Also Verh. Berl. med. Ges. (1936) 1937, 67: 175-89. ------ & Krautwald, A. Ueber chronische Schlafmittelvergiftung. Arch. exp. Path., BerL, 1936-37, 184: 102-4. .Uso Klin. Wschr., 1937, 16: 299.—Ottesen, E., & Kjems, H. [Prophylactic administration of sulfapyridin in poisoning with hypnotics] Ugeskr. laeger, 1941, 103: 1583.—Panse, F. Verbreitung und Folgen des Opiat- und Schlafmittelmissbrauchs in Deutschland. Oeff. Gesundhdienst, 1935, 1: B, 73-6.—Renner, A. Ueber Schlaf- mittelgebrauch und -missbraurh. Fortscb. Ther., 1932, 8: 609-17.—Restriction of sale of sleeping potions. J. Am. M. Ass., 1940, 115: 140.—Riebeling, C. Bemerkungen zur Pathologie und Therapie der Schlafmittelvergiftungen. Psy- chiat. neur. Wschr., 1935, 37: 125-7.—Saphra, J. Ueber- dosierung bei Schlafmitteln. Med. Welt, 1928, 2: 1800.— Schwab, R., & Jung, J. Ueber Wirkung von chemischen Weckieizen bei Schlafmittelvergiftung de> Meerschweinchens. Zschr. ges. exp. Med.. 1930, 99: 749-5'. —Willcox, W. Dis- cussion on the uses and dangers of hvpnotic drugs other than alkaloids. Proc. R. Soc. M., Lond., 1934, 27: Sect. Joint Dis., 489-518. Also Brit. M. J., 1934, 1: 415-8. Also Australas. J. Pharm., 1935, n. ser., 16: 1129-33. Also Med. J. Australia, 1935, 2: 499. Also Pharm. J., Lond., 1935, 4. ser., 81: 295.— Wondolowski, L. S. The aggravation of mental symptoms by excessive use of hypnotics and sedatives. Psychiat. Q., 1940, 14: 121-7. . ---- Therapeutic use. Renner, A. Schlafmittelthornpie. 12f>p. S? Berl., 1925. Allaying pain on the battlefield. J. Am. M. Ass., 1941, 117: 949.—Becker, W. Aerztliche Verschreibung von Betiiubungs- mitteln. Med. Welt, 1940, 14: 1072.—Billings, E. G. A new method of administering hypnotics for the purpose of controlling sleep disorders characterized bv early morning awakening. Dis. Nerv. Syst., 1942,3:38-47.- Buell.H. Leber die klinische Priifung des Praparats Nervinum vegetabile Nattermann. Psychiat. neur. Wschr., 1941, 13: 190.—Broad (The) field of hypnotic medication; a modern hypnotic without undesirable side effects: its many uses. Ther. Notes, Detr., 1934, 41: 127 31.—Butturini. L. (di ipnotici nella terapia moderna. Gior. med. prat., 1935, 17: 412-0.- t'amredon, S. Considerations sur le choix d'hvpnotique. Lvon med., 1933, 152: 233. Also J. m6d. Paris, 1934, 54: 43— Cattell, McK.. Gold. H. [et al.] Conference on therapy; hypnotics and sedatives. N. York State J. M., 1942, 42: 67-75.— Gebser, G. Leber Anwcndungs- moglichkeiten und die notwendige Sliiike eines Schlafmittels. Med. Welt, 1938, 12: 1424.—Grabfield. (;. P. The use of hypnotics. J. .\n>- M. Ass., 1936, 107: 1381-4. Also Bol. Of. san. panamer., 1939, 18: 327-33.—Gruningcr, U. Die Noctal- dosierung und -wirkung im Kindesalter. Zsehr. ges. exp. Med., 1938-39, 104: 796-803.—Henderson, V. E. The use of h\p- notics. Canad. M. Ass. J., 1935, 32: 645 7—Herszky, P. Praktische Erfahrungen mit Schlafmitteln. Med. Klin., Berl 1928, 24: 743.—Hoff, H., & Wermer, P. Neue Anwendungs- gebiete der Schlafmittel. Wien. med. Wschr., 1928, 78: 1187- 9.—Kl iiber. Zur Frage der Schlafmittelverordnung. Med. Welt, 1934, 8: 1067.—McNiven, A. A discussion on hypnotics and analgesics; hypnotics in psychiatric practice. Glasgow M. J., 1930, 126:' 162-74.—Mitzscherling, R. Ueber Schlaf- mittelwirkung und -verordnung. Psychiat. neur. Wschr., 1939, 41: 525.—Schenk. P. Die Verwendung von Glyzerindinitrat anstelle von Nitroglyzerin zur Beseitigung krankhafter Gefiiss- spasmen und Einschlafstorungen. Fortsch. Ther., 1936, 12: 155-9.—Schmidt, W. Wann kommt der Arzt ohne Schlaf- mittel aus? Deut. med. Wschr., 1936, 62: 1921.—Schoen, K. Schlafmitteltherapie. Arch. exp. Path., Berl., 1936, 181: 62- 79.------Ueber Indikation und Anwendung von Schlaf- mitteln. Erg. inn. Med. Kinderh., 1936, 50: 429-79.—Spence, J. C. The effects of bromides and chloral on children. Arch. Dis. Childh., Lond., 1942, 17: 61.—Weese, H. Modern treat- ment by hypnotics and basal narcosis. Brit. J. Anaesth., 1930, 13: 177; 1936-37, 14: 8. Also Schmerz, 1936, 9: 1-16.—Weiss, S. The clinical use and dangers of hypnotics. J. Am. M. Ass., 1936, 107: 2104-9. HYPNOTISM. See also Hypnosis; Somnambulism; Sugges- tion; Telepathy. Belfiore, G. Magnetismo e ipnotismo. 5. ed 466p. 16? Milano, 1918. Brotteatjx, P. L'hypnotisme moderne. 83p. 25cm. Par., 1938. Cannon, A. The science of hypnotism. 12Gp. 8? Lond. [1936] Cook, W. W. Practical lessons in hypnotism 264p. 8? Chic. [1901] Forel, A. Der Hypnotismus oder die Sug- gestion und die Psychotherapie; ihre psycho- logische, psychophysiologische und medizinische Bedeutung mit Einschluss der Psyehanalyse, sowie der Telepathiefrage; ein Lehrbuch fiir Studierende sowie fiir weitere Kreise. 10. & 11. Aufl. 377p. 8? Stuttg., 1921. Gerling, R. Handbuch der hypnotischen Suggestion; Anleitung zur Erteilung von Heil- und Erziehungs-Suggestionen aus der Praxis fur die Praxis. 4. Aufl. 266p. 8? Lpz. [n. d.] Orton, J. L. Hypnotism; the friend of man: an aid to health, efficiency and happiness. 280p. 8? Lond. [1933] Schilder, P., & Katjders, O. Lehrbuch der Hypnose. llOp. 8? Wien, 1926. ---- [The same] Hypnosis. Transl. by Simon Rothenberg. 118p. 8? N. Y., 1927. Winn, R. B. Scientific hypnotism. 168p. 20cm. Bost. [1939] Bromberg, W. Hypnotism. In his Mind of Man, N. Y.. 1937, 105-83.—Erickson, M. H. A brief survey of hypnotism, Med. Rec, N. Y., 1934, 140: 609-13—Funk, A. Ricerche critiche intorno ai concetti fondamentali dello ipnotismo Arch. gen. neur., Nocera, 1935, 16: 253-60.—Hogan, G. F Hypnotism. Med. J. Tufts Coll. School M., 1938-39, 5: No. 1 HYPNOTISM 961 HYPOCHONDRIA 8.—Levy-Suhl, M. Ueber Hypnotismus und seine Beziehungen zur Psychoanalyse. Ber. Allg. arztl. Kongr. Psychother., 1927, 2. Congr., 297-303.—Nathan, M. L'hypnotisme. Presse med ' 1929, 37: 1221.—Raginsky, B. B. Hypnotism and its relation to anesthesia. J. Connecticut M. Soc, 1938, 2: 527-33.— Stein, M. R. Hypnotism to-day. Sc. Month., 1930, 31: 80- 8.—Strauss, E. B. Hypnotism. In Brit. Encycl. M. Pract (Rolleston, H.) Lond., 1938, 7: 34-41.—Young, P. C. Hyp- notism. Psychol. Bull., 1926, 23: 504-23.------A general review of the literature on hypnotism. Ibid., 1927, 24: 540-00. ------A general review of the literature on hypnotism and suggestion. Ibid., 1931, 28: 367-91. ---- History. See also Mesmerism, etc. Bramwell, J. M. Hypnotism; its history, practice and theory. 3. ed. 480p. 8? Lond., 1930. Reimer, H. *Die Forschungen James Braids iiber die Hypnose und ihre Bedeutung fiir die Heilkunde [Munster] lOOp. 21cm. Bottrop, 1935. HYPO ... For subnormal conditions and functions be- ginning with this prefix see names of organs, parts, and functions: e. g., Blood chemistry, Chloride: Deficiency for Hypochloremia, etc. HYPOCHLORITE. See under Chlorine. HYPOCHONDRIA. See also Anxiety; Depressive states; Emotion, Bodily changes; Psychoneurosis. Gillespie, R. D. Hypochondria. 104p. 16? Lond., 1929. Nathan, M. Les malades dits imaginaires. 12? Par., 1931. Wichmann, B. *Autonome Hypochondrie; Beitrag zur Psychopathologie und klinischen Abgrenzung der Hypochondrie. 62p. 8? Mun- ster, 1931. Abadie, J. L'hypochondrie et la constitution hypochondri- aque. J. mid. Bordeaux, 1930, 107: 783-92.—Ameline, M. Hypochondrie, gu6risseurs et psychologie des masses. Ann. mid. psjchol., Par., 1931, 89: pt 2, 248-71.—Barrancos, A. Sindrome de Cotard. Sem. med., B. Air., 1927, 34: pt 1, 1537- 42.—Bauer, W. W. Forty years' experience. Hygeia, Chic, 1939, 17: 1100-2.—Beley, A. P. L. Hypochondrie delirante schizophrfinique et autres dfelires hypochondriaques. Gaz. hop., 1937 110: 1485-93.—Benon, R. Hy-pocondrie et melancolie. Bull' med., Par., 1926, 40: 410-4.—Bisch, L. E. Doengas imaginativas. Impr. med., Rio, 1941, 17: No. 333, 146-8 — Brown, F. The bodily complaint: a study of hypochondriasis. J. Ment. Sc, Lond., 1936, 82: 295-359.—Carp, E. A. D. E. Zur psychoanalytischen Auffassung der Hypochondrie. Zschr. ges. Neur. Psychiat., 1928, 115: 478-86.—Codet, H. Aspects usuels de l'hypochondrie. Progr. med., Par., 1920, 41: 1873- 5 —Courbon, P. Hypocondrie et pathologie de dfeoeuvrement. Ann. med. psychol., Par., 1931, 89: pt 1, 337-44.------& Mars, L. Syndrome mixte d'hypocondrie. Ibid., 1935, 93: pt 1 84-90.—Cremona, G. Ipocondriaci persecutori di medici. Arch, antrop. crim., Tor., 1934, 54: 16-30— Derch y Marsal, F. Hipocondria celosa en la infancia. Rev. homeop., Barce!., 1893, 4: 4-7.—Dublineau, J., & Caron. Evolution d'un d&ire hypocondriaque vers un etat d'excitation pseudo-demen- tielle. Ann. med. psychol., Par., 1933, 91: pt 1, 624-9,- Espejo, L. D. Leiastenia e hipocondria. Actas Jornad. neuropsiquidtr. panamer. (1939) 1940, 2. reun., 2: 397-400.— Estape, J. M. La hipocondria y los estados hipocondrlacos en medicina legal. Ponenc. Jornad. neuropsiquidtr. panamer., 1939 2. reun., 1: 165-92.—Gillespie, R. D. Hypochondria; its definition, nosology and psychopathology. Guy's Hosp. Rep., Lond., 1928, 78: 408-60.------Allison, R. S. [et al.] Dis- cussion on hypochondria. Proc. R. Soc. M., Lond., 1928-29, 22: Sect. Med., 1-8.—Hamel, J., & Buisson, R. Anxiete chez un deprime hypochondriaque; heureux effet de la vagotonme. Ann. med. psychol., Par., 1936, 94: 823-7—Hesnard, A. Le mecanisme psychanalytique de la psychonSvrose hypochondri- aque (k propos d'une observation) Rev. fr. psychanal., 1929, 3- 110-21. ------ Nouvelle contribution k 1 etude psycha- nalytique de la psychon6vrose hypocondriaque. Ibid 1930- 31 4- 549-64—Hirschfeld, M. Sexuelle Hypochondrie und Sk'rupclsucht. Zsclir. Sexwiss., 1915-16, 2: 121-31.—Hohman, L B Presentation of a case of hypochondriacal depression. Med. Clin. N. America, 1933, 17: 1241-53.—Hutchison, R. Hypochondriasis: individual, vicarious, ami communal. Brit. M. J 1934, 1: 365-7.—Jahrreiss, W. Das hypochondrische Denken (ein Beitrag zur Frage nach dem Auf'bau hypochon- dnseher Ideen) Arch. Psychiat., Berl., 1930,92:686-823.— Kanner, L. The invalid reaction in children. J. Pediat., S. Louis, 1937, 11: 341-55.—Katzenelbogen, S. Iatrogenic factors in diseases. Dis. Nerv. Svst.. 1941. 2: 342-5.—Levy. D. M. Body interest in children and hypochondriasis. Am. J. Psychiat., 1932, 12: 295.—Levy-Valensi, J. Thoughts on hypochondria._ French M. Rev., Par., 1932, 2: 355—Lorand, A. S. A narcissistic neurosis with hypochondriac symptoms. Psychoanal. Rev., 1928, 15: 261-77.—McGraw, R. B., & Piotrowski, Z. Treatment of the hypochondriac N. York State J. M., 1941, 41: 1833-7—McKinley, J. C, & Hathaway, S. R. A multiphasic personality schedule, Minnesota; a differential study of hypochondriasis. J. Psychol., Provincet., 1940, 10: 255-68.—McNiel, E. E. Hypochondriasis. Tr. Hawaii M. Ass., 1939, 49: 132-8.—Marix. Sur un cas de psycho-n6vrose avec obsessions hypocondriaques d'origine labyrinthique consecutive k une fracture du rocher. Bull. Soc. med. chir. Bordeaux, 1911, 49-55.—Mazza, A. L'ipocondria persecutoria. Riv. sper. freniat., 1932-33, 56: 440-54.— Mendoza, J. de. Notas sobre la hipocondria. Ponenc. Jornad. neuropsiquidtr. panamer., 1939, 2. reun., 1: 195-205.—Nathan, M. L'hypocondrie de couverture. Monde mid., 1931, 41: 838-42/—Peon del Valle, J. Hipocondria y constitucion. Ponenc. Jornad. neuropsiquidtr. panamer., 1939, 2. reun., 1: 209-32.—Reich, W. Ueber die chronische hypochondrische Neurasthenie mit genitaler Asthenic Intprnat. Zschr. Psy- choanal., 1926, 12: 25-39.—Richards, E. L. Following the hypochondriacal child for a decade. J. Pediat., S. Louis, 1941, 18: 528-37.—Rovasio, A. II sentimento di distaceo negli ipocondriaci. Rass. stud, psichiat., 1934, 23: 320-8.—Roxo. H. Loealisacao nosographica da hypocondria. Ponenc. Jornad. neuropsiquidtr. panamer., 1939, 2. reun., 1: 235-41.—Schwarz, H. Zirkumskripte Hypochondrien. Mschr. Psychiat., 1929, 72: 150-64.—Sicco, A. Hipocondria y manifestaciones hipo- condrfacas. Rev. psiquiat. crim., B. Air., 1939, 4: 39; 183. Also Ponenc. Jornad. neuropsiquidtr. panamer., 1939, 2. reun., 1: 245-302.—Smith, D. H. Hypochondriasis. J. S. Carolina M. Ass., 1933, 29: 140-3.—Stekel, W. Zur Psychogenese einer hypochrondrischen Stfirung. Psychother. Prax., Wien, 1934, 1: 165.—Uribe Cualla, G. La hipocondria en medicina legal. Ponenc Jornad. neuropsiquidtr. panamer., 1939, 2. reun, 1: 305-67.—Vapori (I) del secolo galante. Minerva med., Tor., 1940, 31: pt 2, varia, 404-0 (microfilm)—Watters, T. A. Hypochondriacal states. J. Arkansas M. Soc, 1937-38, 34: 231-5.—Wichmann, B. Autonome Hypochondrie; Beitrag zur Psychopathologie und klinischen Abgrenzung der hypochon- drischen Zustande. Allg. Zschr. Psychiat., 1932, 97: 293-340. HYPODERAEUM. See also Echinostomidae; Trematoda. Morishita, K., & Tsuchimochi, K. Notes on 4 avian tre- matodes from Formosa, with a remark on the life history of Hypoderaeum conoideum (Bloch) studies on trematode parasites of the domestic birds in Formosa. Taiwan igakkai zasshi, 1925, No. 243, 2 pl. HYPODERMA. See also Oestridae. Mote, D. C. The ox warble flies. 45p. 8? Wooster, Ohio, 1928. Tarlier, A. L. D. *L'Hypodernia bovis chez le cheval [Alfort] 47p. 8? Par., 1930. Carpentier, G., & Pelletier, L. A propos d'un cas d'hypo- dermose equine; la larve de l'hypoderme du boeuf anive-t-il k maturite chez le cheval? Rec med. v6t., 1936, 112: 705-11.— Eichhorn, A. Anaphylaxis from hypoderma larvae? Vet. Med., Chic, 1924, 19: 44.—Eichler, W. Ueber Dassellarven vom Elch (Alces alces L.) . Zschr. Parasitenk., 1938-39, 10: 549-52. ------ Zur Sammel-, Zucht-und Praparationstechnik der Larven und Fliegen unserer Rinderdasselfliegen. Zschr. hyg. Zool., 1940, 32: 97-106.—Gebauer, O. The behaviour of H. bovis in animal experiments and the percutaneous penetra- tion of first-stage larvae. Vet. Bull., Lond., 1942, 12: 96.— Girard, R. Un cas devolution d'Hypoderma bovis De Geer sur le cheval. C. rend. Acad, sc, 1939, 208: 306.—Hill, G. F. The buffalo-fly in North Australia. Proc Panpacific Sc. Congr., 1923, 1: 409-11.—Knipling, E. F. The larval stages of Hypoderma lineatum Devillers and Hypoderma bovis Degeer. J. Parasit., Urbana, 1935, 21: 70-82.—Larrousse, F. Descrip- tion de l'Hypoderma corinnae Crivelli, 1862. Arch. Inst. Pasteur Algerie, 1929, 7: 217-9, pl—MacDougall, R. S. Ox warble flies. Vet. J., Lond., 1935, 91: 472-81, 2 pl.—Mocsy, J. Hautdassellarvenkrankheit der Rinder und der Renntiere; liypodermosis. Deliber. Congr. derm, internat. (1935) 1935- 37, 9. Congr., 1: 585.—Natvig, L. R. Ueber die Differential- diagnose der Larven von Hypoderma bovis und H. lineatum. In Festschr. B. Nocht, Hamb., 1937, 386-93.—Nitsche. O. Die Rinderdassellarve und ihr Vorkommen beim Pferde. Zschr. Veterinark., 1933, 45: 401-5.—Ono, S. Studies on hypodermatotoxin, toxin obtained form the larvae of Hypo- derma sp. at the oesophageal stage; its action on the blood 227475—vol. 7, 4th series----61 HYPODERMA 962 HYPOGASTRIC ARTERY coagulation. J. Jap. Soc. Vet. Sc, 1931, 10: 230.------ Studies on hypodermatotoxin, toxin obtained from the larvae of Hypoderma sp. at the esophageal stage; biologic significance of hypodermatotopin from point of view of its hemorrhagenic and dermolytic actions. Mukden Inst. Infect. Dis. Animals, 1932, 2: 267. ------ Studies on warble-flies of Manchuria and inner Mongolia. Kitasato Arch., 1938, 15: 199-246, 8 pl.—Peter. Beitrag zur experimentellen Erzeugung anaphylak- tischer Zustande bei Rindern mit dem Gewebssaft von Hvpo- dermenlarven. Berl. tieriirztl. Wschr., 1928, 44: 417-20.— Popesco-Baran, M. Presence des larves d'Hypoderma bovis au second stade devolution dans le canal rachidien de la g6nisse. Bull. Acad. mid. Roumanie, 1939, 4: 396-8. Also Bull. Soc. path, exot., Par., 1939, 32: 157-9.—Ribeiro dos Santos. Une rare localisation du Hypoderma bovis chez I'homme. Gior. ital. derm, sif., 1931, 72: 1623.—Riley, C. V. The ox bot in the United States. Insect Life, Wash., 1892, 4:— Roubaud, E., & Pfirard, C. Etudes sur l'hypoderme ou varron des bcerufs; les extraits d'oestres et l'immunisation. Bull. Soc. Eath. exot., Par., 1924, 17: 259-72.—Salerno, A. Osservazioni iologiche sull'Hypoderma bovis nell'Agro Romano. Riv. parasit., 1939, 3: 171-86.—Schmid, F. Beitrag zur Biologie der Dasselfliegen, Hypoderma bovis und Hvpoderma lineatum. Zschr. Infektkr. Haustiere, 1939, 55: 217-43.—Spann, J. Die Biologie der Dasselfliege nach dem Stande der neuesten Forschungen. Munch, tierarztl. Wschr., 1928, 79: 173-5; 1934, 85: 25-8.—Terada, B., & Ono, S. The toxicological investigation in the toxic substance obtained from the larvae of Hypoderma sp. of Mongolian cattle at the oesophageal stage. J. Jap. Soc. Vet. Sc, 1930, 9: 219-20, 3 pl. Also Mukden Inst, Infect. Dis. Animals, 1932, 2: 263—Topsent, E. Second cas de mviase hypodermique dans le Morbihan. Arch, parasit., Par., 1908-9, 13: 483-9.—Werdelin, K. [Hypoderma larvae in army horses] Medded. Haerens Heste, 1934, 28: 31-41.— Zottner, G., & Coste, E. Evolution complete d'Hvpoderma bovis chez le cheval. C. rend. Soc. biol., 1939, 131: 907. ---- Control. Chatjdet, M. *Contribution a la lutte contre l'hypoderme, cestre des bovins [Zurich] 48p. 8? Vevey, 1934. Lebeau, G. *L'hypodermose du bceuf (Hypo- derma bovis de Geer) son importance au point de vue de l'agriculture et de l'industrie du cuir; la lutte pour sa destruction [Alfort] 44p. 8? Par., 1927. Baudot, E. A. R. F. [Combatting the horse fly in Germany] Tschr. diergeneesk., 1934, 61: 303-10. ------ & de Boer, E. [Derris extracts in combatting horse-fly larvae] Ibid., 974- 93.—Blagoveshchensky, D. J., & Pavlovsky, E. N. Zur Biologie und zur Bekampfung der Hautbremse (Hypoderma bovis de Geer) Zschr. Parasitenk., 1930-31, 3: 185-204 — Blieck, L. de, & Baudet, E. A. R. F. [Prevention of Hypoderma] Tschr. diergeneesk., 1927, 54: 454-7.—Control (The) of warble fly; derris root preparations. Pharm. J., Lond., 1936, 4. ser., 82: 423.—Gansser, A. Zum Problem der Abtotung von Dassellarven. Schweiz. Arch. Tierh., 1932, 74: 31-5.— Giitze, R. Die Bekampfdng des Dassellarvenbefalls der Rinder. Deut. tierarztl. Wschr., 1932, 40: 449-51.—Kolbe. F. Neueres iiber Hvpoderma bovis und seine Bekampfung. Zschr. Fleisch Milchhyg., 1929, 39: 317; 1931-32, 42: 157.—Pearson, A. M. An improved method for the determination of cattle flv spray repellence. J. Econ. Entom., 1935, 28: 160.—Peter. Weitere Mitteilungen zur Bekampfung der Rinderdasselfliegen. Berl. tierarztl. Wschr., 1929, 45: 137-9.—Reisinger, L. Beitrag zur Bekampfung der Dasselfliegen des Rindes in Oesterreich. Wien. tierarztl. Mschr., 1933, 20: 641-50.—Stiefenhofer, G. Die Bekampfung der Dasselplage mit Hakelnadel und Pinzette. Berl. tierarztl. Wschr., 1932, 48: 179-81.—Warble-fly (The) campaign in Scotland; the work of the committee of the High- land and Agricultural Society of Scotland. Vet. Rec, Lond., 1935, 15: 315-9. ---- Human infestation. See also Myiasis. Balzer, F., Dantin & Landesmann. Un cas de myiase rampante due k l'Hypoderma bovis. Bull. Soc. fr. derm, svph., Par., 1913, 24: 219-26.—Billingsley, G. D., & Templeton, H. J. Human myiasis, Hypoderma bovis De G. California West. M., 1938, 49: 58.—Francaviglia, M. C. Altro caso di myiasis nell'uomo per larva cuticolare d'Hypoderma bovis (De Geer) Policlinico, 1912, 19: sez. prat., 1593-5.—Natvig, L. R. Hypo- derma lineatum als fakultativer Parasit eines norwegischen Madchens. In Parasites (Pavlovsky, E.) Moskva, 1935, 272- 4.—Ribeiro dos Santos. Localisation rare de l'Hypoderma bovis chez I'homme. Ann. parasit., Par., 1931, 9: 512. HYPODERMATACEAE. Tehon, L. R. New species and taxonomic changes in the Hypodermataceae. Mycologia, Lancaster, 1939, 31:675-92. HYPODERMOCLYSIS. See Injection, subcutaneous. HYPOGASTRIC artery. Analasian. I.. A. [Corona mortis from the nnatonio-elinieiil view-point] Khirurgia. Moskva, 1938, No. 10, 87-93. Ashley, F. L., & Anson, B. J. The hypogastric artery in Ameri- can whites and Negroes. Am. J. Phys. Anthrop., 1941, 28: 381-91, 3 pl.—Brunner. H. C. Aneurysma der A. hvpogastricn dextra, einen entziindlichen Adnextumor vortiiuschend. Zbl. Gyn., 1925, 49: 603-6.—Brunzel, H. K. Zur Bekampfung von Blutungen aus der Arteria glutaea superior durch Unterbindung der Arteria hypogastrica; ein Beitrag zur Frage der Naoh- blutungen auf dem Wege des KoUateialkreislaufes. Deut. Zschr. Chir., 1918, 147: 375-81- Dentin. I.. ParticolariU di struttura delle arterie ipogastrica e ilinea emerna del bambino. Boll. Soc. ital. biol. sper., 1935, 10: 175 8. Finaly, R. [Com- plications following ligation of the 2 hypogastric arteries] Ned. tschr. geneesk., 1925, 69: pt 1, 1115-9, pl.- Lafourcade, J. An6vrisme de l'artere hypogastrique droite; ligature de l'hypo- gastrique par la voie transperitoneale; sympathetic neurectomy; report of 7 cases in which the superior hypogastric plexus (presacral nerve) was resected J Am. M. Ass., 1933, 101: 1295-9. Also Zbl. Gyn., 1934, 58: 2603-8. Tumor. Hoffman, S. J. Neurocv toma derived from a ganglioneu- roma of the hypogastric plexus. Am. J. Dis. Child., 1935, 49. 135-46. HYPOGASTRIUM. See also Genital hair; Mons veneris. Himmelman, V. [Clinicopathology of hypogastric sar- comae] Omsky med. J., 1926, 1: No. 2-3, 58-61.—Silva Mello, A. da. O signal do hypogastrio esquerdo. Brasil med., 1935, 49: 965-8. HYPOGEIC acid. Zimovsky, N. [Oxidation of 2,3-hypogeic acid with alkaline permanganate and with Caro's reagent] J. Russ. fiz. khim. obshch., khim. ch., 1915, 47: 2121-4. HYPOGLOSSAL canal. See also Hypoglossal nerve. Cutore, G. Sulla molteplicitS, di canali precondiloidei: osservazioni anatomo-comparative. Arch. ital. anat., 1926, 23: 340-57, 2 pl.—Fregonara, G. Aspetti radiologici del canale del nervo ipoglosso. Osp. maggiore Novara, 1938,15: 480-90.— Rossoni, R. La rappresentazione radiografica del canale dell'ipoglosso con la nuova tecnica di Busi per la radiografia dei canali ottici (mediante il craniostato a Pallettoni) Ann. radiol., Bologna, 1934, 8: 333-45. HYPOGLOSSAL nerve. See also Cerebral nerves. Berblinger, A. ^Untersuchungen iiber das Vulpian-Heidenhain'sche Phanomen und seine Ermudungserscheinungen. 15p. 8? Freib. i. B., 1935. Pinheiro Rodrigues, A. A. *Ansa hypo- glossi; novos subsidios para o seu estudo anat6- mico. 325p. 8? Porto, 1929. Baptista Netto. Observacoes anatomicas; formacao variavel da alga do hipoglosso, 2 casos. Arch. Inst. Benjamin Baptista, Rio, 1937, 3: 135-47.—Barnard, J. W. The mammalian hypo- glossal nucleus; a preliminary report. Univ. Hosp. Bull., Ann Arb., 1937, 3: 41. ------ The hypoglossal complex of verte- brates. J. Comp. Neur., 1940, 72: 489-524. Also repr — Belou, P., Decotto, J. Anomalia de la rama descendente del nervio hipogloso mayor. Rev. As. med. argent., 1937, 51: 240.—Boyd, J. D. The sensory component of the hypoglossal nerve in the rabbit. J. Anat., Lond., 1940-41, 75: 330-45, 2 pl.—Cirio, J. J., & Galli, L. A. Anastomosis del segundo nervio cervical con la rama descendente del hipogloso; anomalia del asa del hipogloso. Sem. med., B. Air., 1939, 46: pt 2, 260.— Downman, C. B. B. Afferent fibres of the hypoglossal nerve. J. Physiol., Lond., 1938, 94: No. 3, Suppl., 1. Also J. Anat., Lond., 1938-39, 73: 387-95.—Goldin, L. S. Zur Frage der Zusammensetzung des Hypoglossuskernes und fdvr die Zellen- gruppen, die mit seinen Wurzeln topographisch zusammen- hangen. Anat. Anz., 1934, 78: 81-9.—Guttmann, V. [Experi- mental study of the function of descending branch of the hypo- glossus in a dog] Cas. lek. 6esk., 1912, 51: 775-8.—Nakamura, T. Der Rollersche Kern; eine vergleichend anatomische Untersuchung. Arb. Neur. Inst. Wien., 1930, 32: 61-94.— Pasqualino, G. II nucleo del nervo ipoglosso nei cane. Ricer. morf., 1929, 9: 229-43.—Parhon, C, & Goldstein, M. Sur l'origine de la branche descendante de l'hypoglossc Roumanie med., 1899, 7: 44-6.—Pearson. A. A. The hypoglossal nerve in human embryos. J. Comp. Neur., 1939, 71: 21-39.—Pomme, R., & Duguet, J. Physiologie du nerf grand hypoglosse. Gaz. hop., 1934, 107: 1181-6.—Sakurai, T. Extrapyramidal! Kern und extrapyramidale Fasern im Accessorius und Hypo- glossus. Mitt. Med. Ges. Tokyo, 1937, 51: H. 12, 1.—Shell- shear, J. L. The blood supply of the hypoglossal nucleus. J. Anat., Lond., 1926-27, 61: 279-82, 3 pl.—Speciale, A. Sul valore dell'anastomosi del plesso cervicale profondo col nervo ipoglosso. Boll. Soc. ital. biol. sper., 1939, 14: 406—Staderini, R. Nucleus praepositus nervi hypoglossi, o nucleo intercalato? Anat Anz., 1938-39, 87: 101-5.—Tarkhan, A. A. Ueber das Vorhandensein afferenter Fasern im Nervus hypoglossus. Arch. Psychiat., Berl., 1936, 105: 475-83.—Taylor E W. Hypoglossal (twelfth) nerve. In Mod. Med. (Osier) Phila., 1910 7: 585-7, pl.—Tournade, A., & Chevillot, M. Au sujet de l'experience Philippeaux-Vulpian. C. rend. Acad, sc, 1937, 204- 1136-9— Uematsu, K. Ueber den Plexus hypoglosso- cervicalis des Menschen. Acta Scholae med Univ. Kioto, 1927-28, 10: 287-317, 8 diag.------Ueber die Zusammen- setzung des Plexus hypoglossocervicahs der Katze. Ibid., 367-84 pl—Vilhena, H. de. Sobre a ansa do hypoglosso. Arch, anat., Lisb., 1912-13, 1: 83—Wischnewsky, A. S. Die Aufbautypen des Ramus descendens nervi hypoglossi ^schr. ges. Anat., 1. Abt., 1930, 92: 551-64.-Young, AW & Tarlov, I M Hypoglossal, twelfth, nerve. Cyclop. Med. (Piersol- Bortz) Phila., 1939, 10: 480-2. ---- Disease, and tumor. Staehr, H. G. *Untersuchungen des Hypo- glossuskernes in Serienschnitten bei Paralytikern. 19p. 23cm. Bresl., 1937. Baptista Netto. Observacoes anatomicas; f ormacao vanayel da alga do hipoglosso com disposigao anomala da veia jugular interna. Arch. Inst. Benjamin Baptista Rio, 1939, 5 427.— CaDella F Voluminoso neurofibroma del nervo ipoglosso in un caso di malatta di Recklinghausen familiare. Riv. chir., HYPOGLOSSAL NERVE 964 HYPOSPADIAS Nap.. 1030 2: 169-92. Friedman, L., & Kisenbcrg. A. A. Neurofibroma of the b\ poglnssal nerve. Ann. Suig., 19:55, 101 : 834-8 —Goldenberg. N. A., A- Sandler, J. G. In cas de paralysie i-nlep du nerf hypoglo.-se. Rev. otoneur., Par., 1931, 9: 429-34.- Curvich, J. S. [Symptomatology of wounds of the nervi hypoglossi J. nevropat. psikhiat., Moskva, 1915-10, 15: 353 74.— Hcyniann [Isolierte Yerletzung des Hvpoglossus] Berl. klin. Wschr., 1919. 56: 378.—Laux & Arnal. Anomalie du nerf grand hvpoglosse. Arch. Sue. sc. med. biol. Montpellier, 1929-30,11:118-20—Martel, T. de, Suhirana, A., & Guillaume, J. Voluminoso neurinoma del hipogloso con desarrollo iuxta- bulboprotuberancial. Ars medica, Barcel., 1933, 9: 416-9. Also Rev. neur., Par., 1933. 40: pt 1, 1173-6.— Tanaka, K. A case of paralysis of the hypoglossal nerve due to dental abscess. Sei i kwai M. J.. 1907, 26: 145-52.—Tereshkovich, A. [Isolated paralysis of the left hvpoglossal nerve] J. nevro- pat. psikhiat.. Moskva. 1910, 10: 1542-" Trabattoni, C. Paralisi bilateiale dell'ipoglosso di origine traumatica. Osp. maixgioie. Milano. 1932. 20: 109.— Ulrich, K. Hypoglossus- laliinungeii bei Anginen. Schweiz. med. Wschr., 1934. 64: I 14-7. -Wertheim. A. Ein Fall von isolierter Verletzung des Nervus hypoglossus. Deut. Zschr. Chir., 1909, 98: 94.— Worster-Drought, C. Two cases of hvpoglossal nerve involve- ment for diagnosis. Proc. R. Soc. M., Lond., 1926-27, 20: Sect. Neur., 13. HYPOGLYCEMIA. See Blood sugar, low. HYPOPHARYNX. See under Pharynx. HYPOPHOSPHATE. See under Phosphorus. HYPOPHYSIS. See Pituitary. For the so-called pharyngeal hypophysis see under Pharynx. HYPOPLEURA. Werneck, F. L. Sur une nouvelle espece de pou (Hypo- pleura brasiliensis) (". rend. Soe. bio!., 1932, 109: 754. HYPOSPADIAS. Sec also Epispadias; Urethra, Abnormity. Rabison, J. *Beitrag zur Kenntnis der Hypo- spadie [Leipzig] 44p. 8? Dresd., 1923. Bhandari, S. I.. A case of hypospadias with double channel urethra. Ind. M. Gaz., 1931, 66: 444.—Blair, V. P., & ByarH, L. T. Hypospadias and epispadias. J. Urol., Bait., 1938, 40: 814-25.—Duquesne, I. Hypospadia penis. Ned. tschr. geneesk., 1912, 2: 336-41.—Friihmann, P., & Sternberg, H. Untersuchungen an Krvptorchen und Hvpospadcn. Arch. klin. Chir., 1930, ISO: 633 73.- Funkquist, II. Uebei Verer- bung von Hypospadie bei Ziegen. Biol, gen., Wien, 1931, 8: 59-64, 1 tab.—Lamherson, IL H. Gonococcal infections in the male associated with hypospadias. Rocky Mountain M. J., 1940, 37: 668-71.—Lopez Carrion, J. Algunas consideraciones sobre ties casos de hypospadias. Urol. clin. Hosp. provinc. Madrid, 1928-30, 2: 311-7. Majocchi, D. Di una singolare impronta ocellata congenita del prepuzio con ipospadia bala- nica. Rendic. Accad. sc. Ist. Bologna, 1914-15, 19: 121-3.— Meyer, H. W. Hypospadias. Surgery, 1940, 8: 781-90.— Murray, J. J., & Bookhalter, S. A case of complete hypos- padias. Brit. M. J., 1938, 2: 659.—Ottow, B. Ueber konge- nitale Polypen der llarnrohre bei Hypospadia peni-scrotalis. Zschr. urol. Chir., 1931, 32: 0-1-8.—Pickerell, P. A case of hypospadias. Med. J. Australia, 1928, 1: 527.—Pires de Lima, J. A. Hipospadias e erro de sexo. Arq. anat., Lisb., 1937, 18: 43-8.—Raust, R. Hypospadias vulviforme chez un bovide adulte. Rec. med. v6t., 1939, 115: 344-9.—Rizzatti, G. Ipospadia peniena causa di nullity di contratto matri- moniale. Gior. clin. med., 1932, 13: 1308-15.—Roder. Hypo- spadie beim Pferd. Berl. tierarztl. Wschr., 1929, 45: 797.— Schiinfeld. M. [Atresia of the urethral orifice with peno- scrotal hvpospadia-] Cas. lek. cesk., 1931, 70: 921-3 — Shaw. N. D.. Reinhardt. C. H., & Brunet, W. M. Gonococcal infections in the male associated with hypospadias. N. England J. M.. 1937, 217: 624-7.—Sievers, R. Anomalien am Penis; ihre Beziehungen zur Hypospadie und ihre Deutung Deut Zschr. Chir., 1926, 199: 2x0-306— Steiner, F. Zur Erblichkeit der Hypospadie. Munch, med. Wschr., 1936, 83: 1271.— Tarabuchin, M. [H\ po-padia scrotalis] Vrach. delo, 1927, io: 442.—Thompson, A. R. Hypospadias, its effects, symptoms, and treatment; a review of 101 eases. Lancet, Lond. 1937 2- 429-32—Voute. P. A. [Hypospadia of the penis in (dizygotic) twins] Ned. tschr. geneesk.. 1933, 77: 2431-33, pl.—West, C. McL. A case of well marked hypospadias. Irish J Al Se 1927, 6. ser.. 2t>-33. 4 pl.- Yokota. K., & Hasama, T. Ilvpo spadie. Mitt. Med. Akad. Kioto, 1935, 15: 900. ---- female. Siebeht, P. *Ueber weibliche Hyposptidie; ein Beitrag zur Vereibungslehre [Konigsberg] lip. S? Frankf. a. M., 1925. De Gironcoli, F. Inkontinenz infolge schwerer Ihpospudic der weiblichen llarnrohre und gleichzeitiger eUopischet llain- eitcrmiindung. Zschr. urol. Chir., 1930, 42: 152 0. (ireene, R. R. Production of experimental hypospadias in the female rat. Proc Soc Exp. Biol., X. Y., 1937-38. 36: 503-6.----- Btirrill, M. W., & Ivy, A. C. Estrogen-induced hypospadias in the female rat. Ibid., 1910, 43: 32 5. ---- Treatment. Arlt, L. [L.] *Ueber eine neue Plastik bei Hypospadie. 29p. 8? Halle a. S., 1932. Bierbaum [H.] H. *Die Erfolge der Hy- pospadie-Operationen seit 1907 an der Ber- liner Chirurgischen-Universitatsklinik. 24p. 8? [Berl.] 1934. Fermaud, E. *Le traitement de 1'hypo- spadias balanique. 61p. 8? Geneve, 1927. Gueguen, P. M. *Cure de l'hypospadins balanique par le procedd de M. le professeur Duvergey. 41p. 25cm. Bord., 193S. Habermann, H. *Ueber die Hypospadie beim Manne und ihre Behandlung; mit besonderer Berucksichtigung von 18 Fallen aus der Chiiur- gischen Universitats-Poliklinik in Kiel [Kiel] 31p. 8? Gutersloh, 1935. Heynen, L:. *Ueber den plastischen Ersatz der Harnrohrendefekte mit besonderer Beriick- sichtigung der perinealen Hypospadie [Konigs- berg] 26p. 8? Lpz., 1932. Also Zschr. Urol., 1932, 26: Valen/.uela Lavin, G. *E1 hipospadias y la operacion de Ombredanne. 104p. 8? Santiago, 1929. Wittig, R. W. *Die Operation der Hypo- spadie beim Manne (Auszug) Gp. 8? Borna- Lpz., 1!)25. Barros, I,. A propositi) do tratamenlo das hypospadias. Biusil med., 1933, 47: 383-7- Begg, It. C. Perineal hypo- spadias; icport of a case; treatment bv tunnelling and skin graft. N. Zealand M. J., 1935, 34: 378 83.- Birkenfeld, W. Beitrag zur Operation der mannlichen Hypospadie. Arch. klin. Chir., 1927, 145: 445-54.—Browne, D. An operalion for hypospadias. Lancet, Lond., 1936, 1: NI 3.---Cabot, H. The treatment of hypospadias in theory and practice. N. England J. M., 1936, 214: 871-6.------Walters, W., & Counseller, V. S. Principles of treatment of hypospadias. Collect. Tapers Mavo Clin., 1934, 26: 367-74. Also J. Urol., Bait., 1935, 33: 400-7.—Cappellen, D. van [Urethroplasty in hypospadias] Ned. tschr. geneesk., 1928, 72: pt 1, 356-8 — Cecil, A. B. Treatment of a case of male hypospadias. Surg. Clin. N. America, 1928, 8: 1343-50.------Surgery of hypospadias and epispadias in the male. J. Urol., Bait., 1932, 27: 507-37. Also West. .1. Surg., 1932, 40: 297-315.—Chauvin, E-, & Lahayville, C. I'lastie de la verge par 1'inclusion tempo- raire intra-scrotale du penis; application a la cure de l'hypo- spadias. Marseille med., 1920, 63: 1109-19.—Coe, H. E. The use of stainless steel wire in operation for hypospadia-- Urol. Cut. Rev., 1941, 45: 297.—Conger, K. B. A first stage operative method in the treatment of hypospadias -inTi Surg., 1941, 113: 1105.— Creevy, C. D. The operative treats ment of hypospadias, with a report of 13 eases Surgerv 1938, 3: 719-31. ------ Note on straightening the hypo- spadiac penis. Ibid., 1940, 8: 777-80. Davis, D. M. The pedicle tube-graft in the surgical treatment of hypospadias in the male with a new method of closing small urethral fistulas Surg. Gyn. Obst., 1940, 71: 790-0. Also Tr. Am \ss Geni- tourin. Surgeons (1940) 1941, 33: 221 -35- Drachinskaia, E. S. [Xove-Josserand's treatment in hypospadia] Vest khir., 1933, 30: 284-9.- Duvergey. Un procede personnel pour la cure radicale de 1'hypospadias balanique. Bordeaux chir., 1939, 10: 156.—Edmunds, A. The treatment of hypo- spadias. Med. Press & Circ, Dubl., 1937, 194: 456-62.— Elbim, A. La cure des hypospadias peniens peuo-serotaux et perineo-scrotaux par le procede de Duplav .1 urol med Par., 1935, 40: 484-98.—Falcone, R. Su di un nuovo processo per la cura dell'ipospadia. Arch. ital. chir., 1927 18- 497- 514.—Flynn, K. Hypospadias treated by the Ornbredannt technique. Med. J. Australia, 1937, 2: 479, pl Gatewood. Plastic repair of hypospadias. Surg. Clin. N. America, 1934 14: 783-8.------A simple technic for the cure of hypo^ spadias. Tr. West. Surg. Ass., 1935. 45: 106-19. Also Sure Gyn. Obst., 1936, 63: 05.5-9. Godard, H. Les uretroplasties^ revue generale des proeedes d'un'troplastic utilisant les trans^ HYPOSPADIAS 965 HYPOSPADIAS plantations libres ou pedicures dans la restauration des hypo- spadias ou des pertes de substance de l'uretre masculin. J urol. med., Par., 1936, 42: 105-42.—Hagner, F. R. A new method for straightening the penis in hypospadias. J. Am M. Ass., 1932, 99: 116. Also repr.—11 esse, E. Ein Fall von perinealer Hypospadie bei einem Manne, welcher im Verlaufe von 26 Jahren als Individuum weiblichen Geschlechts gait und durch Operation in seinen Rechten hergestellt wurde Zschr. urol. Chir., 1933, 38: 18-22.—Heynen, U. Ueber den plastischen Ersatz der Harnrohrendefekte, mit besonderer Berucksichtigung der perinealen Hypospadie. Zschr. Urol., 1932, 26: 338-59.—Horhammer, C. Die Operation der Hypo- spadie. Chirurg, 1938, 10: 159-61.—Humby, G., & Higgins, T. T. A one-stage operation for hypospadias. Brit. J. Surg., 1941-42, 29: 84-92—Kairis, Z. Ueber eine Modifikation der Nissen schen Hypospadieoperation. Zbl. Chir., 1930, 57: 3047.—Kurtzahn, H. Ueber die operative Behandlung der perinealen Hypospadie (Harnrohren- und Praputiumplastik) Ibid., 1931, 58: 1945-8.—Lasserre, C. Hypospadias traite avec succes par le procede d'Ombredanne apr&s echec du procede de Beck-von Hacker. Bordeaux chir., 1932, 3: 189- 91.—Leveuf, J. Refection de l'uretre chez les hypospades par accolement temporaire de la verge au scrotum. Bull. Soc. nat. chir., Par., 1935, 61: 30; 861. ------ Un cas de greffe temporaire de la verge sur le scrotum pour hypospadias peno- scrotal. M6m. Acad, chir., Par., 1936, 62: 1149-51.------ & Godard, H. La greffe temporaire de la verge sur le scrotum dans la cure de l'hypospadias. J. chir., Par., 1936, 48: 328- 41.—Levi, D. Operation for penoscrotal hypospadias. Lancet, Lond., 1940, 2: 777.—Lowsley, O. S., Begg, C. L. A 3-stage operation for the repair of hypospadias; report of cases. Actas Congr. amer. urol. (1937) B. Air., 1939, 2. Congr., 2: 866-9. Also J. Am. M. Ass., 1938, 110: 487-93.—Lydston, G. F. A systematic operation for penile hypospadias and other defects of the urethral floor. Am. Surg., 1908, 47: 68-71, 3 pl.— Lyle, H. H. M. Ombredanne's pouch operation for hypo- spadias. Ibid., 1933, 98: 513-9. Also Tr. Am. Surg. Ass., 1933, 51: 33-9.—McGuire, S. Formation of urethra in hypo- spadia by grafting mucous lining of appendix, with report of 3 cases. Tr. South. Surg. Ass. (1926) 1927, 39: 91-6, 5 pl. ------ Use of appendix vermiformis in the formation of a urethra in hypospadia. Ann. Surg., 1927, 85: 391-9.—Mclndoe A. H. An operation for the cure of adult hypospadias. Brit. M. J., 1937, 1: 385. ------■ The treatment of hypospadias. Am. J. Surg., 1938, 38: 176-85.—McKenna, C. M. Hypo- spadias; observations on its surgical correction. J. Am. M. Ass., 1939, 113: 2138-43.—McWhorter, G. L. Operative treatment for extensive hypospadias. Surg. Clin. N. America, 1930, 10: 275-82.—Marion, H. Refection atypique d'un uretre perineal. Bull. Soc. fr. urol., 1935, 271-7. Also J. urol. med., Par., 1935, 40: 182-8.—Martin. De la possibilite de refaire en une seule operation l'uretre d'un Irypospade par le procede de Duplay. Bull. Soc. fr. urol., 1928, 7: 242-4. Also J. urol. med. chir., Par., 1928, 26: 564-71.—Mathieu, P. Procede de cure radicale en un temps de l'hypospadias bala- nique ou penien juxtabalanique. Arch. mal. reins, 1927-28, 3: 224-30. ------ Hypospadias penien traite en un temps par un procede personnel k lambeau cutane. Bull. Soc. nat. chir., Par., 1930, 56: 1314-6. ------ Traitement en un temps de l'hypospadias balanique ou juxtabalanique. J. chir., Par., 1932, 39: 481-6.—Mayet, H. La technique du procede de von Acker dans le traitement des hypospadias. Bull. Soc. chir. Paris, 1929, 21: 394-403. Also Paris chir., 1929, 21: 149-54.—Meyer, H. Eine einfache Hautplastik fiir die Behandlung der Hypospadie. Arch. klin. Chir., 1929, 155: 588-96.—Michelson, J. M. Traitement de l'hypospadias par la methode de Nove Josserand. Arch. mal. reins, 1927, 2: 513-7.—Moszkowicz, L. Soil man die Hypospadie operieren? Chirurg, 1934, 6: 401.—Nagel, Z. Zum Aufsatz von Dozent Dr A. Fischer uber Neue Methode zur Operation der Hypo- spadiasis und der Defekte der Pars pendula urethrae in Nr. 12 (1922) dieser Zeitschrift. Zbl. Chir., 1922, 49: 982-4.— Nesbit, R. M. The foreskin is completely circumscribed. Surgery, 1940, 8: 560. —----Plastic procedure for correction of hypospadias. Tr. Am. Ass. Genitourin. Surgeons (1940) 1941, 33: 237-42. Also J. Urol., Bait., 1941, 45: 699-702.— Nissen, R. Harnrohrenplastik zur Beseitigung der skrotalen Hypospadie. Zbl. Chir., 1929, 56: 962-4.—Ombredanne, L. Correction autoplastique de la verge dans l'hypospadias. Monde med., 1926, 36: 521-7.—Perpina, V. S. Unsere Opera- tionsmethoden bei peno-balanischer und peno-skrotaler Hypospadie. Zbl. Chir., 1934, 61: 209-16.—Perrier, C. Cure de l'hypospadias vulviforme. Congr. fr. urol., 1932 32: 335-40.—Pettinari, V. Metodi chirurgici nella cura della ipospadia. Arch. ital. urol., 1933-34, 10: 555-88—Ritchie, H. P. Hypospadias; a discussion of the subject from the view- point of reconstructive surgery. Tr. West. Surg. Ass. (1938) 1939, 48: 101-35. Also Surgery, 1939, 5: 911-31.—Rocher, H. L. Hypospadias peno-serotal traite par le procede de Leveuf. Bordeaux chir., 1937, 8: 108.—Rosenstein, P. Ersatz der fehleiiden Harnrohre bei der Hypospadia penoscrotalis durch Blasenschleimhaut. Zschr. Urol., 1929, 23: 627-37. ------ Die Heilung der Hypospadie durch Transplantation von Blasenschleimhaut. Zbl. Chir., 1931, 58: 1874-80.— Rubritius, H. Wann soil man die Hypospadie operieren/ Chirurg, 1934, 6: 402.—Salleras, J. Hipospadias peneano; pMstica de uretra por el metodo de Marion. Sem. med., B. Air., 1931. 38: pt 1, 10.—Salmon & Liotier. Quatre cas d hy- pospadias operes. Arch. mal. reins, 1936-37, 10: 193-200 — Sanchis Perpina, V. Nuestros procedimientos operatorios .mte los hipospadias penobaldneios y pene-escrotales. Arch. med., Madr., 1933, 36: 989-1002.—Schuppel, A. Zur Therapie der Hypospadia perinealis. Zschr. Urol., 1929, 23: 753-61.— Smith, C. K. Surgical procedure for correction of hypospadias. J. Urol., Bait., 1938, 40: 239-47.—Torre, D. L'uretroplastica ueH'ipospadia peno-scrotale col metodo Passaggi-Galliera. Ann. ital. chir., 1937, 16: 841-54.—Troell, A. [An operated case of bulbo-scrotal hypospadias] Sven. lak. tidn., 1926, 23: 897-904. Also Zschr. urol. Chir., 1927, 22: 372-6.—Ven- gerovsky, I. S. [Clinical treatment of hypospadia in men] Sovet. pediat., 1936, No. 10, 62-73.—Wade, R. B. Treatment ot hypospadias. Austral. N. Zealand J. Surg., 1933, 2: 417.— Walters, W. I. Ombredanne-Lyle operation for hypospadias; removal of branched stone from the kidney: presentation of cases. Proc. Mayo Clin., 1933, 8: 467-9. ------ Successful operations for hypospadias. Tr. South. Surg. Ass., 1935, 48: 364-73. Also Ann. Surg., 1936, 103: 949-58.—Young, H. H. Note on treatment of hypospadias. J. Urol., Bait., 1939, 42: 470-3. ------ Operative treatment of true hermaphro- ditism; a new technic for curing hypospadias. Arch. Surg., 1940,41:557-08. Also repr.—Zechel, G. Eine Hvpospadie- plastik. Arch. klin. Chir., 1928, 153: 491-4.—Zeller, O. Ersatz der fehlenden Harnrohre bei Hypospadia scrotalis durch gestielten Lappen aus der Blasenwand. Med. Welt, 1935, 9: 565-7.—Zenker, R. Ergebnisse der operativen Be- handlung schwerer Hypospadieformen durch Epidcrmisplastik, Chirurg. 1934. 6: 576-8. HYPOTHALAMUS. See Brain, Diencephalon: Hypothalamus. HYPOTRICHIDA. See Ciliata. HYPOTRICHOSIS. See Alopecia; Hairlessness. HYPOXANTHINE. See under Xanthine. HYRACOTHERIUM. Cooper, C. F. The genus Hyracotherium; a revision and description of new specimens found in England. Philos. Tr. R. Soc London, 1932, ser. B, 221: 431-48, 3 pl. HYRONDELLE, Y., 1911- *Les pyo, nephrites; la chirurgie conservatrice dans les pyonephrites de l'essorage. 117p. 8? Lyon, M. & L. Riou, 1937. HYRONIMUS, Raymond Gustave, 1904- *Contribution a l'etude clinique du B. C. G. 97p. 8? Par., Soc. Gen. Impr., 1929. HYRONIMUS-COLOMBU, Suzanne, 1904- *A propos de la reaction de Desmoulieres chez l'enfant et du depistage de l'heredo-syphilis. 39p. 8? Par., Soc. Gen. Impr., 1930. HYRTL, Jozsef, 1811-94. Favaro, G. Giuseppe Hyrtl e ITnstituto anatomico di Modena. In Rass. stor. Univ. Modena, 1930, fase 2: 67-77.— Plahl, F. Josef von Hyrtl. Wien. med. Wschr., 1928, 78: 1172. HYSERN y Molleras, Joaquin, 1804-83. Biografia. Arch. ter. med. quir., Barcel., 1882-83, 1: 138- 40.—Nogue [Roca] J. Necrologfa. Rev. homeop. catalana, 1883, 1: 121-4. HYSLOP, James H. Psychical research and survival, x, 208p. 12? Lond., G. Bell & sons, 1914. HYSLOP, Theophilus Bulkeley. The border- land; some of the problems of insanitv. 4 p. 1. 31 Op. 12? Lond., P. Allan & co. [1924] ----'The great abnormals. xxvii, 289p. 8? N. Y., G. H. Doran co. [1925] HYSSOPUS. Balansard, J., & Rizzo, C. Sur les effets choliniques des preparations d'hysope. C. rend. Soc. biol., 1934, 115: 1293 •">. HYSTER ... For medical subjects related to the womb see Uterus, and its subheadings. HYSTERESIS 966 HYSTERIA HYSTERESIS. See also Magnetism. Neergaard, K. von. Die Bedeutung der Hysteresistheorie Rashevskvs fiir die dvnamische Reaktionspathologie der Kon- ^titutions- und Erbleiden. Med. Welt, 19 10, 14: 673-7.—Rao, K. S. Hysteresis in sorption; scanning of the hysteresis loop; tilania gel-water system. J. Phys. Chem., 19li, 54: 506-12. ------Hysteresis in sorption; permanence and scanning of the hysteresis loop; silica gel-water system. Ibid., 513-7. ------Hysteresis in sorption; permanence and scanning of the hysteresis loop; silica gel-carbon tetrachloride system. Ibid., 517-21.------Hysteresis in sorption; permanence, scanning and drift of the hysteresis loop; ferric oxide gel-carbon tetra- chloride and ferric oxide gel-water systems. Ibid., 522-31. HYSTERIA. See also Anxiety hysteria; Catalepsy; Con- tracture; Deglutition, Disorder; Dissociated states; Dyskinesia; Eye, Neurosis; Globus hystericus; Psychoneurosis, etc. Blum, K. Hysterie (die abnormen seelischen Reaktionen im Korperlichen) 36p. 8? Lpz., 1927. Bretjek, J., & Freud, S. Studies in hysteria. 241p. 23^cm. N. Y., 1936. Dide, M. L'hysterie et Involution humaine. 250p. 8? Par. [1935] Kretschmer, E. Ueber Hysterie. 115p. 8? Lpz., 1923. Also 2. Aufl. 128p. 8? Lpz., 1927. Also Engl, transl. by O. H. Boltz. 120p. 8? X. Y., 1926. Mesquita, M. *Hysteria. 77p. 8? Lisb., 1884. Thorton, A. W. Hysterical women; their trials, tears, tricks and tantrums. 195p. 16? Chic, 1893. Trubert, E. Contribution a l'etude de l'hysterie et de la mythomanie. 146p. 8? Par., 1929. Vinciion, J. Hysterie. 122p. 18? Par., 1925. Babinski. J. Hvsterie-pithiatisme. Bull. Soc. med. hop. Paiis, 1928. 3. ser., 52: 1507-21.—Best, W. P. Hysteria. Nat. Eclect. M Ass. Q., 1925-26, 17: 239-48.—Bethea, O. W. An adventure in hysteria. Med. Rec, N. V., 1934, 140: 519.- Bouman, L. [Hysteria] Psychiat. neur. bl., Amst., 1935, 39: 445-86.—Cammarata, J. A. Hysteria. Ment. Health Bull., Danville, 1940, 18: No. 3, 11-8. -Cassone, V. J. Hysteria. Ibid., 1937, 15: 13-5— Evrard, E. L'hvst6rie. Liege med., 1935, 28: 1437-50.—Ey, H. L'hysterie. Gaz. hop., 1935, 108: 797; 829.—Hartenberg, P. Que reste-t-il de l'hysterie? Clini- que, Par., 1933, 28: 315-7. Also J. med. Paris, 1934, 54: 936 — Hicks, R. A. Hysteria; the hidden monster. Hygeia, Chic, 1936, 14: 882-0.—Hysteria reviewed. Lancet, Lond., 1940, 2: 564.—Jablonszky, A. [Neurasthenia and hvsteria] Gvogvaszat, 1929, 68: 070-6.—Jelliffe, S. E. Hysteria. Cyclop. Med. (Piersol-Bortz) Phila., 1939, 7: 397-418.—Kasparek, A. Hysterie. Mitt. Biochem.. 1938, 45: 59-62.—Mackenzie, M. Hysteria. In his Human Mind, Phila., 1941, 24-6.—Marinescu, G. [Certain data on hysteria] Romania med., 1936, 14: 41; 57; 73.—Maxwell, C. H. Hysteria. West Virginia M. J., 1926, 21: 120-8.—Neustatter, W. L. Hysteria. In his Earlv Treat, Nerv. Ment. Disord., Lond., 1940, 17.5-87.—Nyiro. G. Ueber die Hvsterie. Psvchiat. neur. Wschr., 1927, 29: 27-30.— Patrick. H. T. Hysteria, Illinois M. J., 1928, 53: 261-7.— Rosenfeld, M. Die hysterischen und die psychogenen Seelen- storungen. Deut. med. Wschr., 1928, 54: 923-7.—Spessard, T. N. Hysteria. Virginia M. Month., 1938, 65: 736-8.— Steyerthal, A. Was ist Hvsterie? Psvchiat. neur. Wschr., 1927, 29: 191-201.—Vries. E. de [Hysteria] Geneesk. tschr. Ned. Indie, 1935, 75: 1833.—White, W. H. Hysteria. Guy's Hosp. Gaz., Lond., 1928, 42: 357-64. ---- Casuistics. Riga, A. Storia clinica di un isterismo e sua polimorfia. 29p. 2212cm. Nap., 1883. Brauchle, A. Zwei interessante Falle von schwerer Hysterie. Deut, med. Wschr., 1927, 53: 99-101.—Brown, M. W. A case of hysteria according to Saint Luke. Med. J. & Rec, 1933, 137: 387.—Cade, A. Sur un syndrome nerveux, hystero-organique, de diagnostic difficile. Bull. Soc. med. hop. Lyon, 1906, 5: 141-6. Also Lyon med., 1906, 106: 643-7.—Caraballo, V. Casos de histeria en varones. Rev. med. cir., Barranquilla, 1940, 7: No. 1, Ed. extraordinaria, 216-20.—Faibushevich, V. [Case of self-healing of amnesia and hysterical mutism] Vrach. gaz., 1927, 31: 1664-7.—Freud, S. Fragment d'une analyse d'hysterie (Dora) Rev. fr. psychanal., 1928, 2: 1-112.— Guitti, E. Osservazioni cliniche. Gior. progr. pat., Venez., 1847, ser. 2, 12: 229-58, 2 pi.—IHslerische (Die) alte Jungfer. Fortsch. Med., 1927, 2: pt 2, 219-22. -Jelgersma, H. C. [The life of a hysterical woman] Psvchiat. neur. bl., Amst., 1920, 30: 263-72. —Kamath, M. L., & Kutumbiah, P. A case of hysteria (narcolepsy?) Ind. M. Gaz., 1929, 64: 87.- Kempf. E. J. A study of the anaesthesia, convulsions, vomiting, visual constriction, erythema and itching of Mrs V. G. J. Abnorm. Psychol., 1917, 12: 1-24.—Maes. I). Un cas d'hysterie chez un vieillard. Ann. eiectrob., Lille. 1907, 10: 9-1L— Marinesco, G., & Nicolesco, M. J. Note sur un cas d'hysterie. J. neur. psychiat., Brux., 1932, 32: 7-17.—Monat, H. A. An unusual case of hysteria with a retrocursive gait. Med. Bull. Veterans Admin., 1934, 11: 167.— Noble, R. Two interesting cases of hysteria. Med. J. Australia, 1929. 2: 751.- Piccinino, F. Un cas bizarre d'hysterie de forme spiritoide. Ann. sc psvchol., Par., 1912, 22: 339-45.—Risquez, F. A. Del clasico histo'ri.smo. Gac. med. Caracas, 1930, 37: 116.—Sacon, J. I. Sobre 8 casos de histeria. Prensa med. argent., 1941, 28: pt 1, 1213-22. ---- Clinical aspect. Allen, I. M. The physiological approach to the study of hysteria. N. Zealand M. J., 1940, 39: 79-87.— Betzendahl, W. Friihsymptome hysterischer Seelenstorung in ihrer Bedeutung fiir das Zusammenleben in Familie und Beruf. Aerztl. Sach- verst, Ztg, 1939, 45: 183-92.—Cahane, M., & Cahane, T. Sur les formes cliniques de l'hysterie. Arch, internat. neur., Par., 1936, 55: 222-9.—Campbell, C. M. Hvsteria as a practical problem. Bull. New York Acad. M., 1929, 2. ser., 5: 1057- 73.—Carriere, G., & Gineste, P. G. Sur quelques aspects actuels de l'hysterie. Gaz. hop., 1938, 111: 1641-4.—Drum- mond, J. The medical aspect of hysteria. S. Africa M. J., 1932, 6: 181-5.—Hardy, F. P. Hysteria in general practice. J. Arkansas M. Soc, 1935-30, 32: 183.—Josserand, E. Les maladies perimees; l'hysterie. Lyon med., 1932, 150: 685-7.— Lindemann, E. Hysteria as a problem in a general hospital. Med. Clin. N. America, 1938, 22: 591-605.—Lisak, A. Die Hysteriefrage fur den praktischen Arzt. Praxis, Bern, 1937, 26: 585-8.—Sandes, T. L. Surgical aspects of hvsteria. S. Africa M. J., 1932, 6: 187-90.—Wilson, S. A. K. The approach to the study of hysteria. J. Neur. Psychopath., Brist., 1930-31, 11: 193-206. Also Proc. R. Soc. M., Lond., 1930-31, 24: Sect. Psychiat., 2-10. ---- Complication. Cardona, F. Isterismo ed encefalite epidemica cronica. Riv. pat. nerv., 1937, 50: 134-40.—Jacobsen, O. [Imbecility and hysteria] Hospitalstidende, 1930, 73: 339-50.—San Pedro Anchochury. Histeria v tuberculosis. Siglo med., 1932, 90: 591 -94. ----Conversion hysteria. See also Conflict. Giraud, A. *NeVrosc a d6charge [Lyon] 8? Trevaux, 1910. Binswanger, H. Beobachtungen an entspannten und ver- senkten Versuchspersonen; ein Beitrag zu moglichen Mechanis- men bei der Konversionshysterie. Nervenarzt, 1929, 2: 193 207.—Bishop, L. F. The development of tight hemiplegia and aphasia as a result of intensive worry. Am. Med., 1926, n. ser., 21: 187.—Brann, H. W. Conversion hysteria. II. S. Veterans Bur. M. Bull., 1929, 5: 798-800.—Gibson, R. S. A case of conversion hysteria, with some remarks on treatment by the method of abreaction. Practitioner, Lond., 1926, 117: 387-91. ------The etiology of conversion hysteria. Glasgow M. J., 1930, 113: 141-9.—Jelliffe, S. E. Conversion hysteria. Cyclop. Med. (Piersol-Bortz) Phila., 1939, 7: 405-11.—Kirschner, I.. Analyse einer Konversionshysterie in vorgerucktem Lebens- altcr. Internat. Zschr. Psychoanal., 1928, 14: 98-110.— Liss, E. Conversion syndromes. Am. J. Orthopsychiat., 1934, 1: 43-8.—Parcheminey, G. L'hysterie de conversion. Rev. fr. psychanal., 1932, 5: 106-40.—Simonson, E. Erfolgreiche Behandlung einer schweren, multiplen Konversionshysterie durch Katharsis. Internat. Zschr. Psychoanal., 1934, 20: 531-42.—Wilson, G. W. The analysis of a transitory conver- sion symptom simulating pertussis. Internat. J. Psychoanal., Lond., 1935, 16: 474-83. ---- Diagnosis. Krisch, H. Die hysterische Reaktionsweise; Prinzipien der Analyse, Behandlung und Begut- achtung. 97p. 8? Berl., 1928. Anfimov, J. A. [The colloidal Liesegang's rings as a basis of the metameres of the brain with reference to the semeiologv of hysteria] Klin, med., Moskva, 1928, 6: 729-41.—Bamk, H., Gevaudan, Y. [et al.] Crise de catalepsie et crise d'enervement bysteriques; diagnostic differentiel avec les crises symptomati- ques; role du fiechissement des fonctions psychomotrices dans la pathogenie de ces crises. Ann. m6d. psychol., Par., 1935, 93: pt 2, 252-9.—Chapman, R. J. Neurological diagnosis of lis- teria. J. Am. Osteopath. Ass., 1939-40, 39: 268-72. Cohen, I. J. Neurological conditions simulating hysteria. Ment Health Bull., Danville, 1940, No. 4, 13-22.—Courbon, P. Hysterie, schizophrenic pithiatisme et simulation. Ann. med. psychol Par., 1937, 95: pt 2, 268-73.—Federn, P. The determination HYSTERIA 967 HYSTERIA of hysteria versus obsessional neurosis. Psychoanal. Rev 1940, 27: 265-76.—Folly, R. Confusion trop frequente de l'hysterie avec l'epilepsie. Monde med., 1923, 33: 404.------ Recherches sur le diagnostic et le traitement des crises pithiati- ques. Rev. med. est, 1930, 58: 553-01. ------ Nouvelles recherches sur le diagnostic et le traitement des crises pithiati- ques. Ibid., 1931, 59: 590-8—Froment, J. L'abus du diag- nostic d'hysterie ou d'livstei o-traumatisme et ses nn'laits. Gaz. med. France, 1930, 43: 409-13.—Goodman, M. J. ( >aa- neous histamin reaction in diagnosis of hysteria. California West, M., 1939, 50: 419.-Kolle, K. Hysterie als Fehldiagnose; Hamalomyelie; spinales Syndrom bei Diabetes. Med Klin BerL, 1931, 27_: 778-80.—Lhermite, J., & Roussy, G. L'im- portance de l'examen neurologique sous narcose dans les associations organoThysteriques. Rev. neur., Par., 1929, 36: pt 2, 88-92.—Rojas, N. Histeria v errores de diagnostico. Dia med., B. Air., 1932-33, 5: 273. . Also Rev. med. fr., 1933 14: 183-8. Also Arq. med. leg. ident., Rio, 1934, No. 8, 37- 44.—Rothfeld, J. [Differential diagnosis between extra- pyramidal diseases and hysteria] Polska gaz. lek., 1927, 6: 860-4.—Scarpini, V. Sulla necessity della pronta diagnosi e di una sollecita cura dei fenomeni isterici. Gior. med. prat., 1930, 12: 193-204.—Schilder, P. Differential diagnosis of hysterical tremor. Arch. Neur. Psychiat., Chic, 1941, 45: 517-9.— Trisoelo [Hysteria?] Geneesk. tschr. Ned. Indie, 1937, 77: 1125.—Unger, W. Differentialdiagnose der Hysterie. Prakt. Arzt, 1927, n. F., 12: 338; 369. ---- epidemic. Jauneau. Un episode d'hysterie collective k Madagascar. Marseille med., 1928, 65: 1st semest., 392-4.—Olson. W. C. Account of a fainting epidemic in a high school. Psychol. Clin., Phila.. 1928-29, 18: 34-8.—Poccia, D. Una epidemia di iste- rismo. Pensiero med., 1926, 15: 624-7.—Soria, B. Dos casos de imitacion. Arch, pediat. Uruguay, 1935, 6: 509-12.— Sterling, W. [Epidemic of infantile religious hysteria] Warsz. czas. lek., 1936, 13: 728; 749. ---- Etiology. Abely, P., Benon. It. [et al.] Hysterie et etats organiques. Vie med., 1939, 20: 235-67.—Benda, C. E. Ueber hysterische Erscheinungen im Verlauf organischer Erkrankungen. Ner- venarzt, 1930, 3: 206-11.—Claude, H. Rapports de l'hysterie avec la schizophrenic. Ann. med. psychol., Par., 1937, 95:- pt 2, 241-64.—Gorrill, G. W. Hysteroid symptoms in psy- choses other than hysteria. State Hosp. Bull., Utica, 1910-11, n. ser., 3: 249-73.—Guillemin & Willigens. Hysterie d'origine ovarienne. Bull. Soc. obst. gyn. Paris, 1936, 25: 163.— Hysteria caused by shock without physical injury. Brit. M. J., 1941, 1: 343.—Janishevsky, A. E. [Hysteric manifestations in sclerosis disseminata! Tr. obsh. nevropat. Saratov, 1927, 1: 99-109.—Kraulis, W. Zur Vererbung der hysterischen Reaktionsweise. Zschr. ges. Neur. Psychiat., 1931, 136: 174- 258.—McGeorge, J. A. Environment and hysteria. Med. J. Australia, 1932, 2: 655-60.—Nakagawa, K. An experimental study on the aetiology of hysteria. Psychiat. neur. jap., 1936, 40: 01.—Orator, V. Ueber hysterische Komplikationen nach Laparatomien. Zbl. Chir., 1929, 56: 1811-4.—Soderbergh, G. [Sclerose en plaque and hysteria] Hygiea, Stockh., 1925, 87: 40-68.—Weygandt. Hysterie als Erbkrankheit. Zschr. ges. Neur. Psychiat., 1936, 155: 758-82.—Zenope. Sur un nouveau cas d'hysterie par insuffisance ovarienne et hyperthyroidie. Gaz. med. orient, 1924, 69: 751-3. ---- Forensic aspect. Lothholz, K. *Selbstverstummlungen von Hysterischen. 8? Jena, 1931. Zillikens, P. *Ueber Selbstverletzung bei Hysterischen im Anschluss an einen Fall von Selbstverletzung durch Verschlucken von Fremd- korpern (Auszug) 8p. 8? Bonn, 1921. Agostjni, C. False denuncie delle isteriche. Arch, antrop. crim., Tor., 1936, 56: Suppl., 47-65.—Alberca Lorente, R., & Alcantara Saura, E. Sobre las calidades de la histeria y la reintegracion de la capacidad de obrar. Arch, med., Madrid, 1930, 32: 275-88.—Casazza, R. Sull'importanza di fattori psichici in dermatologia (a proposito di autolesioni cutanee in isteriche) Boll. Soc. med. chir., Pavia, 1930, 44: 115-62, 6 pl.—Delfini, C. Simulazione di aggressione e di imbavaglia- mento in una isterica. Gior. psichiat., 1928, 56: No. 3-4, 72-84.—Delhougne, A. Hysterie und Schriftexpertise. Zschr. Menschenk., 1927-28, 3: 93-106.—Desolaux, L. Un cas de fausse accusation chez une hysterique. Ann. med. leg., 1926, 6: 273-8.—Diillner, M. Zur Begutachtung der Hysterie. Aerztl. Sachverst. Ztg, 1928, 34: 305-10.—Eliasberg, W. Nur ein Fall von Hysterie; gibt es eine Verschlimmerung eines als Dienstbeschadigung anerkannten hysterischen Leidensr Med Welt, 1929, 3: 968-70.—Engel, H. Zur Beurteilung der Berufsfahigkeit i. S. des Angestelltenversicherungsgesetzes bei hysterischen Zustanden. Med. Klin., Berl., 1926, 22: 1849- 51.—Ferrarini, C. Deduzioni psichiatrico-forensi e i enten di Kretschmer sull'isteria (perizia Bugliesi) Rass. stud, psi- chiat., 1927, 326-48.—Haenisch, G. Begutachtung von Scha- delverletzungcn und Neurosen. Med. Welt, 1929, 3: 1295 — Klinkenberg, F. Zur Frage des Zusammenhanges zwischen Hysterie und Tod. Deut. Zschr. gerichtl. Med., 1929, 13: 397-406.—Menesini, G. La valutazione medico-legale delle sindromi isteriche. Gazz. osped., 1927, 48: 1105-8.—Miani, G. Su di un caso di patomimia; provocazione di finte lesioni cutanee con rossetto in isterica. Atti Soc. ital. derm, sif., 1938, 1: 976-81.—Nicoletti, F. Singolare autolesionismo, provocata in modo speciale dall'introduzione in vagina di numerose pietre e mendacio in un caso d'isterismo. Arch, antrop. crim., Tor., 1933, 53: 1587-95.—Rubensohn, E. Ist Hysterie beziehungs- weise deren Folgen schadenersatzpflichtig? Fortsch. Med., 1929, 47: 79.—Stefani, S. Un caso di autolesionismo e simulata aggressione in soggetto isterico. Riv. med., 1927, 35: 145-9.— Thibierge, G. Les excoriations neurotiques. Bull, med., Par., 1926, 40: 354-8.—Weichbrodt. Die Begutachtung hysterischer Reaktionen und die Gefahren ihrer Ueberwertung fur Staat und Arzt. Med. Klin., BerL, 1927, 23: 496. ---- Ganser's symptom. Altende Navarro, F. Los fen6menos psico-motores y los estados crepusculares histericos desde el punto de vista de su finalidad psicol6gica. Rev. psiquiat. Uruguay, 1938, 3: No. 14, 39-85.—De Marco, A. Sopra un caso di psicosi amnesica isterica carceraria con emiplegia. Cervello, 1931, 10: 177-92.—■ Stem, E. S., & Whiles, W. H. Three Ganser states and Hamlet. J. Ment. Sc, Lond., 1942, 88: 134-41. ---- History of research. Kraemer, R. *Der Wandel in den wissen- schaftlichen Anschauungen iiber Hysterie unter besonderer Berucksichtigung der letzten Jahr- zehnte. 24p. 8? Wurzb., 1932. Delmas-Marsalet, P. L'evolution des idees sur l'hysterie. J. med. Bordeaux, 1936, 113: 195-202.—Gaupp, R. Wandlun- gen des Hysteriebegriffes. Mschr. Psychiat., 1938, 99: 233- 68.—Kleij, J. J. van der [Thomas Sydenham's treatise on hysteria] Ned. tschr. geneesk., 1930, 74: pt 2, 4911-8.— Morgenthaler, W. Eine Hysterika zu Begin des 17. Jahr- hunderts. Arch. Gesch. Med., 1926, 18: 196-201.—Padeano, G. L'evolution des idees dans les domaines de I'etiologie, la pathogenie et le traitement de l'hysterie. Rev. med. roumaine, 1930, 3: 5; 57; 109.—Radovici, A. L'hysterie apres Charcot et apres Babinski, devant les progres de la neurologie. J. med. Lyon, 1935, 16: 223-8.—Raymond, P. Marianne Olivonne, la dormeuse de St.-Marcel-d'Ardeche, en Vivarais. Aesculape, Par., 1927, n. ser., 17: 154-8.— Reichardt, M. Wann hat die jetzt herrschende wissenschaftliche Lehre von der hysterischen Reaktion in den facharztlichen Kreisen massgebende Bedeutung erlangt?- Aerztl. Mschr., 1929, 289-97.—Teixeira de Mattos, E. [Case of evil eye in a hysterical woman of Antwerp (1598) with exorcism of the devil] Ned. tschr. geneesk., 1928, 72: pt 1, 1095-103.—Trabaud, J., Sami el Satti &Hosni Sabah. Note sur l'hysterie dans le Proche-Orient. Bull. Acad, med., Par., 1933, 3. ser., 109: 192-5.—Victoria, M. Kretschmer y la histeria. Rev. argent, neur., 1929, 3: 67-74. ---- infantile and juvenile. Charcot, J. M. L'isterismo dei giovinetti. 8p. 22cm. Fir., 1883. Barcaglia, A. Considerazioni su di un caso di isterismo infantile. Pediatria (Riv.) 1938, 46: 230-49.—Baumel, L. Contribution a l'etude pathogenique de l'hysterie et de l'epi- lepsie a propos de 2 fillettes de 14 et 15 ans. Rev. gin. clin. ther., 1910, 24: 577—Bowlby, J. Hysteria in children. In Surv. Child Psychiat. (R. G. Gordon) Lond., 1939, 80-94.— Carbonara, G. Sopra alcuni casi di isterismo infantile. Clin. pediat., Mod., 1926, 8: 417-35.—Cardelle y Pehichet, B., & Muniz Angulo, L. Una histeria infantil curada por el psi- coanalisis. Rev. med. cubana, 1936, 47: 1125-30.—Chatagnon & Couderc, L. Troubles emotionnels suivis de chute associes k des mouvements choreiformes de la face et des membres su- perieurs avec spasticite k type hemipiegique gauche chez un enfant de 10 ans. Bull. Soc. clin. med. ment., Par., 1928, 16: 217-20.—Creak, M. Hysteria in childhood. Brit. J. Child. Dis., 1938, 35: 85-95.—Dieterle, R. R., & Koch, E. J. Experi- mental induction of infantile behavior in major hysteria. J. Nerv. Ment. Dis., 1937, 86: 688-710—Euziere & Margaret. Accidents hysteriques et epileptiques consecutifs k une emo- tion chez un enfant de 12 ans. Montpellier med., 1910, 30: 516-9.—Freud, A. An hysterical symptom in a child of 2 years and 3 months old. Internat. J. Psychoanal., Lond., 1926, 7: 227-9.—Gordon, A. The behavior problem in children, based upon the study of a case of hysterical disability. Med. Times, N. Y., 1933, 61: 36.—Guerin, R. Trois cas d'hysterie infantile. J. med. Bordeaux, 1935, 112: 633-5.— Heuyer, G. A propos de l'hysterie infantile. Arch. med. enf., Par., 1929, 32: 669-71. Also Bull. Soc. pediat. Paris, 1929. 27: 244-8 — Hurtado Flor, C. E. Histeria infantil. An. Soc med. quir. Guayas, 1934, 14: 327-33.—Juarros & Garcia del Diestro. Cooperaci6n al estudio del histerismo infantil. Actas Congr. espan. obst. gin. pediat., 1911, 2. Congr., 639-47.—Lereboullet. Un caso di abbaiamento in un fanciullo. Gazz. osp., 1927, 48: 1137. Also Rev. gen. clin. ther., 1927, 41: 737-9 — McCowan, P. K. Hysteria in childhood. Med. Press & Circ, Lond., 1938, 196: 136-9.—Mase, K. A case of child hysteria. Orient. J. Dis. Inf., Kyoto, 1935, 18: 5.—Nishiyama, K. Drei HYSTERIA 908 HVSTERIA Falle von Kinderhysterie. Taiwan igakkai zasshi, 1934, 33: 3S.—Pagani-Cesa, A. L'isterismo neH'etA infantile. Clin. pediat., Mod.. 1936, 18: 116-23.—Reca, T., & Filippi, F. de. Sindromes psicomotores en la infancia; histeria; tics. Arch. argent, pediat,, 1937, S: 249-62.—Robinson, J. M. Ocular manifestations of hysteria in children. Minnesota M.. 1930, 13: 618-23—Ronjat. I. J. Le cas de Jeannette; psyi■hanalyse et guerison d'une jeune fille hysterique operee 7 fois. Rev. fr. psychanal., 1027. 1: 210-323.—Schlesinger, J. Psycho- therapie des hysterischen Kindes. Jahrb. Kinderh., 1920, 3. F., 62: 21S-20. Tixier, L. Hysterie infantile; variations de ses manifestation^ cliniques. Arch. med. enf., 1930, 33: 90-4.- Wyllie, W. G. Treatment of hysterical disorders in children. Lancet, Lond., 1926, 1: 301. ---- male. De Smeth, J. Observation d'un cas d'hysterie chez I'homme. Presse med. beige, 1868-09, 21: 311-3.—Lillie, H. I. A case report [hysterical paralysis in the male] Tr. Clin. Soc. Univ. Michigan, 1914, 5: 155.—Stoppani, A. Un caso di isterismo maschile post-traumatico con emianestesia sensitivo-sensoriale. Osp. psichiat., Nap., 1933, 1:356-61. ---- Manifestation. Jacob, J. *Zur Symptomatologie der Hysterie. 13p. 8? Kiel. 1926. Baugh, L. D. H. A clinical study of anaesthesia; mental confusion, and moods, in epilepsy, confusional insanity and hysteria. J. -Ment. Sc, Lond., 1910, 56: 093-9.—Berg, W. Leber hysterische Pseudomeningitis. Deut. Zschr. Nervenh., 1930. 112: 85-90.—Boisseau, J. Pseudo-extension de l'orteil, epreuve incorrecte du doigt sur le nez, mictions involontaires iliegitimes, chez un hysterique trepane. Rev. neur., Par., 1930, 65: pt 1, 632-8.—Bostroem, A. Ueber die Bedeutung hy- sterischer Erscheinungen. Deut. med. Wschr., 1933, 59: 637-40.—Brodie. Memorie intorno ad alcune affezioni locali che dipendono daH'isterismo. Filiatre sebezio, Nap., 1837, 13: 323; 380.—Christensen, O. [Examples of the influence of the surroundings on the manifestations and course of hysteria] Ugeskr. laeger, 1929, 91: 823—Dabney, S. G. Ocular symp- toms in hysteria and neurasthenia. Kentucky M. J., 1913, 11: 1046-50.—Eschbach, H. Gros ventre pithiatique chez une enfant. Bull. Soc. pediat. l'aris. 1928, 26: 47-9— Geier, T. A. [Certain data on svmptoms of hvsteria] J. nevropath. psikhiat., Moskva, 1928, 21: 300-6.- Hoi I is, C. B. Throat consciousness. Hahneman. Month., 1936, 71: 1-7.—Janovsky, E. L. [Cases of hysteric tumors of the intestines] Vest, khir., 1928, 14: 71-7.—Kogerer, H. Zur Kenntnis der symptomlosen Hvsterie. Jahrb. Psychiat., 1931-32, 48: 299-302.—Lattes, L., & Sacer- dote, A. Un caso di sindrome isterica oculare con simulazione di emorragia (accertata mediante diagnosi individuale del sangue) Arch, antrop. crim., Tor., 1927, 47: 21-45, pl.— Malan, D. J. Hysterical phenomena in women. S. Africa M. J., 1932, 6: 185-7.—Masini, V. Ancora un caso di sindrome cerebellare in una otitica isterica. Boll. mal. orecchio, 1927, 45: 73-9.—Mayer, E. E. Hysteria; with special reference to the H-R syndrome of Kretschmer. Am. J. Psychiat., 1920-27, 6: 523-44.—Moore, W. P. Neurological changes in hysteria Med. Bull. Veterans Admin., 1934-35, 11: 326.—Mounier- Kuhn. Un cas de niastoidite hysterique. Rev. otoneur., Par., 1930, 8: 183-6.—Nordmann, O. Hysterische, die ein orga- nisches, chirurgisches Leidenvortauschen. Deut. med. Wschr., 1930, 56: 1911.—Oseretzkowsky, A. J. [Observations: the nature of physical symptoms in hysteria] Klin, med., Moskva, 1928, 6: 396-401.—Pavlov, I. P. An attempt to understand the symptoms of hysteria physiologically. In his Condit. Reflex. & Psychiat., N. Y., 1941, 2: 102-16.—Pisk, G. Ueber Veranderungen der hysterischen Symptomatologie in den letzten Jahren. Wien. klin. Wschr., 1930, 49: 938.—Raymond, F., & Janet, P. Un cas du rythme de Cheyne-Stokes dans l'hysterie; influence de l'activite cerebrale sur la respiration. C. rend. Congr. internat. psychol. (1900) 1901, 4. Congr., 524-40.—Rele, V. G. The role of uterus in the manifestations of hysterical symptoms. Marriage Hyg., Bombay, 1934-35, 1: 26-31.—Richet, C. Un paradoxe sur la nutrition jeunes prolonges dans l'hysterie. Medecine, Par., 1930, 11: 657-62.— Riese, W. Wandlungen in den Erscheinungsformen der Hy- sterie. Med. Welt, 1927, 1: 1160.—Rugg-Gunn, M. A. Two cases of somnolence as a manifestation of hysteria. J. R. Nav. M. Serv., 1936, 22: 249-52.—Russell, W. Symposium on hysterical phenomena: psychiatric aspect. S. Africa M. J., 1932, 6: 179-81.—Segal, M. E. The preponderant symptoms of hysteria. Med. Bull. Veterans Admin., 1936-37, 13: 340- 8.—Sgobbo, F. P. Monocontrattura ed anestesia brachiale destra con atrofia muscolare isterica. C. rend. Congr. internat. hydr. clim. geol. ther. (1905) 1906, 7. Congr., 970-6.—Vigot, A. Les petits signes de l'hysterie. Bull. med. Quebec, 1926, 27: 302-7.—Wilder, J. Modificazioni osservate in questi ultimi anni in Germania ed in Austria nelle manifestazioni dell'iste- rismo. Gior. clin. med., 1931, 12: 393-401.—Zauli, G. Sindromi isteriche oculari. Ann. ottalm., 1926, 54: 619-23. ---- Manifestation: Autonomic nervous sys- tem. Andernach, L. Ein Fall von Hysterie mit Oedeme bleu und Differerz de» Kniephanomene. Miinch. med. Wschr., 1909, 56: 2222.—Aoki, T. A case of hvsteria with high temperature. ,1. Orient. M., Dairen, 1925-20, 4: No, 2, 19 -Berkman. J. M., & Horton, B. T. Hysteria associated with absence of sweating: report of a case. Proc. Mayo Clin., 1937, 12: 108 71. Ilolten, G. C. Vom hysterischen Oedem. Deut. Zsehr. Ner- venh., 1922, 73: 319-28.—Bulle, E., & Haase, W. Miliare, disseminierte Hautnekrosen durch vasomotoriscbe Neurose l«ei einer Hysterica. Munch, med. Wschr.. 1927, 74: 1498.— Carnelli, R. Edema neurotrotico. i^tenco, a corazza. Poli- clinico, 1918, 25: sez. med., 12 23.—Cenni, G. La febbre isterica. Riv. med., 1925, 33: 135. Challiol. V, Sindromi isteriche e sistema nervoso-vegetativo. Note psichiat., 1'esaro, 1930, 59: 447-01.—Edgeworth, F. H. On hysterical paroxvs- mal oedema. Q. J. Med., Oxf., 1908-9, 2: 135-45. Fabrizio, A., & Turano, A. Di un singolarissimo ed unico caso di st.illi- cidio sanguigno dalla fronte di una isterica nei venerdl di quaresima. Rinasc. med., 1925, 2: 123; 151.—Fraser, R. A case of hysteria showing spontaneous hyperventilation tetany. J. Ment. Sc, Lond., 1937, 83: 190-201. ------ & Sargant, W. Hyperventilation attacks; a manifestation in hysteria. Brit. M. J., 1938, 1: 378.—Galant, J. S. Saignec reflexe (Guenot) erliiuternde Erganzung zum Aufsatz: Ueber hysterische Ideen. Psychiat. neur. Wschr., 1926, 28: 147.— Galdi, F. Distonia neuro-vegetativa e tipo istero-nevrastenico con spina organica addominale. Riforma med., 1930, 46: 4; 43.—Glorieux. Un cas d'cedeme hysterique. J. neur., Par., 1911, 16: 61-3.—Goebel. Fall von hysterischem Oedem des Arms nach Glassplitterung. Jahrber. Schles. Ges. vaterl. Cult. (1906) 1907, 84: 56-8— Gordon, A. H. Hysterical swelling of the hand. Montreal M. J., 1900, 35: 328-30.—Grossman, J. [Vicarious and secretory derangements in severe hysteriaj Vrach. gaz., 1927. 31: 730-4.—Lebar. Sur l'oedeme hysterique. Bull. Soc. med. hoi). Paris, 1915, 3. ser., 39: 757-00.—Michel & Bakouris, G. Hyperthermic hysterique. Rev. gen. clin. ther., 1930, 44: 181 -4.— Mullen, M. J., & Murphy, E. L. Hysterical oedema. Irish J. M. Sc., 1941, 6. ser., No. 19(i, 561-5.—Pernet, G. Case of oedeme bleu de Charcot. I'roc P. Soc. M., Lond., 1916-17, 10: Sect. Derm., 108-10. Riese, W. Zwei Falle von hysterischem Oedem. Arch. l's\ chiat., BerL, 1915-10, 56: 228-34, 2 pl.—Schultze. Soge- nanntes blaues Oedem. Deut. med. Wschr., 1916,42:433.— Tomesco. Deux observations d'oedemes bleus hysteriques. Montpellier med., 1918, 40: 375-7.—Tripodi, M. L'isterismo in rapporto ad alcuni fenomeni organici (a proposito di un caso di enterorragia isterica) Policlinico, 1931, 38: sez. prat., 1385-90. ---- Manifestation, mental. Janet, P. L'6tat mental des hysteriques; etudes sur divers symptomes hysteriques. 3. 6d. 168p. 8? Par., 1931. Aragon, E. Las mentiras convencionales de la histeria; mitomanfa y mitoplastia. Gac. med. Mexico, 1929, 10: 191- 6.—Benon, R. Hysterie et delire. Bull, med., Par., 1932, 46: 365-70.—Claude, H. Manifestations hysteriques; etat onirique avec fabulation d'origine toxique; exhibitionnismc chez un schizophrene. Rev. gen. clin. ther., 1933, 47: 305-8.— Lautier, J. Pseudo-meiancolie hysterique. Ann. med. psychol., Par., 1928, 86: pt 1, 122-35.—Marinesco, G., & Nicolesco. M, Sur un cas d'amnesie hysterique retrograde avec quelques reflexions sur le mecanisme de l'hysterie. Encephale, 1933, 28: 257-93, 4 pl.—Reeling Brouwer, S. De l'auto-suggestibilite pathologique comme caracteristique de l'hysterie. C. rend. Congr. internat. psychol. (1900) 1901, 4. Congr., 489-511. ---- Manifestation, motor. Michels, G. *Beitrag zur Lehre von der Chorea hysterica. 8? Kiel, 1915. Schoene, W. *Beitrag zur Lehre von den hysterischen Kontrakturen [Kiel] 24p. 8? Stettin, 1927. Abely, X., & Fretet. Un cas de contracture hysterique guerie au bout de 29 ans. Ann. med. psychol., Par., 1936, 94: pt 2, 812-9.—Allen, I. M. Observations on the motor phe- nomena of hysteria. J. Neur. Psychopath., Lond., 1935-36, 16: 1-25.—Ames, T. H., & MacRobert, R. Psychogenic convulsions, the result of a wish. Med. Rec, N. Y., 1915, 87: 899-901.—Balduzzi, O. Les contractures hysteriques des muscles externes de l'ceil. Encephale, 1926, 21: 195-205, pl.— Baruk, H., Gevaudan, Y. [et al.] A propos d'une contracture oculo-palpebrale et d'une paralysie brachiale hysterique; la phase prodromique neuro-vegetative des accidents pithia- tiques. Ann. med. psychol., Par., 1935, 93: pt 2, 241-52. ------Un cas de tremblement hysterique; roles respectifs de la suggestion, de I'emotion et des troubles vegetatifs; traite- ment par le scopochloralose. Ibid., 259-71.—Benon, R. Hysterie; crises; paralysies; contractures. Rev. med., Par., 1934, 51: 113-27.—Callewaert, H. Contracture hysterique des membres inferieurs k I'occasion de I'epidemie de polio- myelite. J. neur. psychiat., Brux., 1930, 30: 504-8.—Claude, H. Contracture hysterique; etat psychasthenique; sentiment d'inferiorite. Rev. gen. clin. ther., 1933, 47: 721-3. ------& Porak, R. Les troubles de la motilite dans les psychonevroses du type hysterique. Progr. med., Par., 1914-15, 30: 512.— Colucci, G. Ricerche sperimentali su di una sindrome coreica HYSTERIA 969 HYSTERIA atipica in soggetto isterico. Cervello, 1934, 14: 269-94.— Conybeare. J. J. Hysterical tetanus. Guy's Hosp. Rep., Lond., 1935, 85: 212-4. Also Clin. J., Lond., 1936, 65: 66-8 — Cristini, R. Un caso di corea atipica in soggetto isterico. Riv. neur., 1935, 8: 355-53.—Dupouy, Tinel & Chatagnon. Choreo-myoclonie hysterique d'origine emotionnelle. Ence- phale, 1926, 21: 562.—Gurstein, T. Hysteria, simulating grave form of postencephalitic Parkinsonism. Klin, med., Moskva, 1927, 5: 702.—Guttmann, E. Tetanische Erschei- nungen beim hysterischen Anfall. Arch. Psychiat., BerL, 1926-27, 79: 498-508.—Haenel, H. Die hysterische Paraki- nesie. Miinch. med. Wschr., 1919, 66: 913.—Marinesco, G., & Nicolesco, M. Des rapports de la contracture hysterique avec la deviation conjuguee de la tete et des yeux, avec rigidite generalisee. Rev. otoneur., Par., 1930, 8: 435-41.—Me- nestrina, G. Due osservazioni non comuni di isterismo oculare. Lettura oft., 1927, 4: 353-61.—Menninger-Ler- chenthal, E. Die Pseudotetania hysterica im Lichte neuerer Forschungen. Zschr. ges. Neur. Psychiat., 1931, 133: 576-600.—Moersch, H. J., & Conner, H. M. Hysterical dysphagia. Arch. Otolar., 1926, 4: 112-9. Also repr.— Papastratigakis. Hysterie et syndromes extra-pyramidaux. Encephale, 1928, 23: 116-27.—Perez Hervada, E. Mtidez y afonfa pitidticas. Arch, med., Madr., 1931, 34: 855-7.— Pinegin [Systematic hysterical akinesia and dyskinesia, developed after injury to the head] Klin, med., Moskva, 1931, 9: 580.—Portell Vila, J. Corea interrumpida con pardKsis histericas. Rev. med. cir. Habana, 1933, 38: 777-93.— Roemer, N. A. A. van de. Tetanus of hysterie? Ned. tschr. geneesk., 1918, 1: 819.—Rouquier, A., & Darre, R. Hysterie et syndromes extrapyramidaux. Encephale, 1928, 23: 756- 67.—Roxo, H. Hemi-chorea hysterica. Brasil med., 1927, 41: pt 1, 439-91.—Ruschke, C. Tetanoider hvsterischer Anfall. Med. WTelt, 1929, 3: 890.—Sanchis Banus. Un caso de pseudo- atetosis histerica. Rev. med., Madr., 1917, 116: 181.— Souders, B. F. Hysterical convergence spasm. Arch. Ophth.. Chic, 1942, 27: 301-5.—Stein. W., & Szmerner, S. [Case of unusual hysterical hyperkinesis] Neur. polska, 1939, 22: 241-3.—Veraguth. Filmvorfuhrung uber einen Fall von hysterischer Kontraktur des linken Knies und Fusses, durch Psychotherapie geheilt. Schewiz. med. Wschr., 1925, 55: 398.—Vinson, P. P., & Schmidt, H. W. Hysterical dysphagia; report of a typical case. Virginia M. Month., 1937-38, 64: 142. ---- Manifestation, motor: Paralysis. Prtjns, H. . *Ueber hysterische Lahmungen und Schiittellahmungen nach Trauma [Kiel] 8? Elmshorn, 1910. Schichhold, G. *Beitrag zur Lehre von der hysterischen Pseudoparese der Beine nach Trauma [Kiel] 8? Sorau, N. L., 1910. Barker, P. P. The diagnosis and treatment of hysterical paralysis; report of a case cured by etherization and suggestion. U. S. Veterans Bur. M. Bull., 1930, 6: 663-70, 3 pl — Berliner, M. Ueber einen Fall von hysterischer Monoplegie. Wien. klin. Wschr., 1914, 27: 939.—Carter, J. W. jr. A case of reactional dissociation (hysterical paralysis) Am. J. Ortho- psychiat., 1937, 7: 219-24.—Claude, H. Paralysie hysterique du membre superieur droit. Clinique, Par., 1911, 6: 823. ------& Lhermitte, J. Les modifications dynamogeniques des centres nerveux inferieurs dans les paralysies ou dans les contractures fonctionnelles. Presse mid., 1918, 26: 1-4.— Descos, A. Paralysie faciale hysterique. Loire med., 1908, 27: 215-8.—Garofalo, M. L. The diagnosis and treatment of hysterical paralyses by the intravenous administration of pentothal sodium; case reports. Connecticut M. J., 1942, 6: 180.—Giampaolo, R. Nuova interpretazione patogenetica delle paralisi isteriche. Pensiero med., 1926, 15: 605.—Gomes, M. Therapeutica da paralvsia hysterica. Tribuna med., Rio, 1929, 23: 183; 199.—Grigorescu, D„ & Lordanescu, C. T. [A case of hysterical monoplegia with illogical disassociation of sensibility] Spitalul, 1928, 48: 278-80.—Guedes de Mello. Da psychotherapia: monoplegia pithiatica. Tribuna med., Rio, 1924, 30: 241-7.—-Harriman, P. L. A case of hysterical paralysis. J. Abnorm. Psychol., 1934-35, 29: 455.—Hurst, A. Hysterical paralysis. In his Med. Dis. War, 2. ed., Lond., 1941, 13-8.—Levy, R. Ueber die Resultate der Kaufmannschen Behandlung [hysterischer Bewegungsstorungen] Munch, med. Wschr., 1917, 64: 170.—Myerson, A. Hysterical paralysis and it* treatment. J. Am. M. Ass., 1935, 105: 1565-7.—Nogueira Ribeiro, L. G. Paralysia hysterica, cura psychotherapica. Brasil med., 1940, 54: 338-40.—Parker, G. Paraplegia, prob- ably hysterical in origin. N. York M. J., 1912, 95: 1205 — Parker, H. L. Hysterical paralysis. Med. Clin. N. America, 1926, 10: 703-14.—Patel. Paralysie hysterique de la main gauche. Lyon med., 1911, 116: 1006.—Perez Hervada, E. A prop6sito de un caso de mtidez y monopardlisis histerica curado por sugesti6n. Arch, med., Madr., 1930, 32: 229-33.— Pershing, H. T. The cure of hysterical paralysis by re-educa- tion of kinesthetic centers. J. Am. M. Ass., 1907, 48: 1568- 70.—Peugniez. Parapiegie hysterique. Bull. Soc. med. Paris, 1934, 264-70.—Reynolds, G. P. Hysterical paraplegia; a case of many years' duration, responding well to treatment. Boston M. & S. J., 1926, 195: 704-7.—Smith, W. A. Hysterical para- plegia with contractures; report of a case of 4 years' duration. 227475—42---62 Piedmont Hosp. Bull., 1926, 3: 106-9.—Somerfield, R., & Tovell, R. M. Case report; successful treatment of hysterical paralysis with pentothal sodium and psychotherapy. Anes- thesiology, 1941, 2: 59.—Steindler, A. On hysterical contrac- tures. Internat. Clin., Phila., 1935, 45. ser., 4: 221-9, 3 pl — Stewart, G. Hysterical paralysis. Hospital, Lond., 1909-10, 47: 563-6. ■----- Case of hysterical brachial monoplegia. Proc R. Soc. M., Lond., 1913-14, 7: Neur. Sect.. 24. ------ Further note on a case of hysterical brachial monoplegia follow- ing electric shock. Ibid., Neur. Sect., 41.—Symonds, C. P. Two cases of hysterical paraplegia. Guy's Hosp. Gaz., Lond., 1928, 42: 323-8— Theron, J. Exageration des reflexes rotuliens et clonus du pied dans un cas de parapiegie hysterique. J. med. Bordeaux, 1912, 42: 697-700.—Tosatti, C. Un caso di para- plegia isterica. Corriere san., 1908, 19: 165-7. ---- Manifestation: Reflexes. Heermann, H. Gibt es totale hysterische Reflexstorungen? Beitr. Anat. Ohres, 1931-32, 29: 417-24.—Jelgersma, H. C. [On the W.-effect (psycho-galvanic reflex) in hysterical condi- tions] Psychiat. neur. bl., Amst., 1926, 30: 281-7.—Marinesco, G., Sager, O., & Kreindler, A. Hysterie et reflexes condition- nels. Rev. neur., Par., 1931, 38: pt 1, 721-31. ------ Nou- velles contributions k l'etude des reflexes conditionnels dans l'hysterie. Ibid., pt 2, 624-9.—Motta Rezende. Reflexos na histeria. Arch, brasil. med., 1926, 16: 53-74, 2 pl.—Pieraccini, A. Rilievi in tema di isterismo; i meccamsmi delle crisi isteriche e i riflessi condizionati. Rass. stud, psichiat., 1930, 19: 3-47.— Stenvers, H. W. [Hysteria and reflexes] Psychiat. neur. bl., Amst., 1935, 39: 568-86. ---- Manifestation: Sense organs. Ab6Iy, X., & Dupont. Un cas de surdite hysterique datant de 28 ans. Ann. med. psychol., Par., 1928, 86: 227-36.— Avalos, E. Diagn6stico retrospectivo de un caso de histeria ocular. Rev. cubana otoneuroft., 1933, 2: 239-50.—Bab, W. Psychogene Sehstorungen. Miinch. med. Wschr., 1937, 84: 612-4.—Best, F. Die Augenstorungen bei Hysterie. Zbl. ges. Ophth., 1933-34, 30: 321-52.—Bourgeois, R. Audition et hysterie. Progr. med., Par., 1933, 1661-7. Also Otorhinolar. internat., Lyon, 1934, 18: 81-7.—Buzoiani, G. La surdite hysterique. Rev. otoneur., Par., 1937, 15: 174-9.—Eszenyi, M. Zur differentialdiagnostischen Bedeutung der Gesichtsfeld- veranderungen bei der Hysterie. Mschr. Psychiat., 1928, 70: 147-60.—Gonzalez, J. de J. Manifestaciones oculares de la histeria y su importancia para el diagn6stico general de la neurosis. Mem. Reun. Soc. oft. mex., 1910, 4: 29-72. ------ Histeria ocular monosintomfitica; contractura de la conver- gencia y de la acomodaci6n. Rev. cubana otoneuroft., 1932, 1: 323-30.—Hautant. A. Examen de la fonction vestibulaire dans un cas de surdite hysterique. Ann. mal. oreille. 1925, 44: 946- 51.—Loddoni, G. Cas de syndrome oculaire hysterique; travail de la Clinique Oculistique de l'Universite de Turin. Ann. ocul., Par., 1928, 165: 357-65. Also Lettura oft., 1928, 5: 92-9.—Mahmoud Zaky. A short note on 5 cases of hysteria in the eye. Bull. Ophth. Soc. Egypt, 1938, 31: 76-82.—Muniz Angulo, L. Mutismo y ceguera histericos curados por el psicoan^lisis y el hipnotismo. Rev. med. cubana, 1937, 48: 675-8.—Rakonitz, E. Hysterische Gesichtsfeldveranderungen und der hysterische Mechanismus. Arch. Psychiat., BerL, 1928, 84: 392-413.—Seale, E. A. Ophthalmological aspects of hys- teria. S. Africa M. J., 1932, 6: 225-7.—Terrien. Quelques manifestations oculaPes interessantes de l'hysterie. C. rend. Congr. alien, neur. France (1907) 1908, 17. Congr., 433-5 — Wilson, R. P. Hysterical disorders of the eye. Bull. Ophth. Soc. Egypt, 1929, 22: 80-5. ---- Manifestation, sensory. Blum, P. A. *Des anesth^sies psychiques dites nerveuses ou hysteriques; 6tude historique, cliniques experimentale et critique. 289p. 8? Nancy, 1906. Bernheim. L'anesthesie hysterique. C. rend. Congr. internat. psychol. (1900) 1901, 4. Congr., 646.—Cable, J. V., & Smirk, F. H. Blood-pressure-raising reflexes in hysterical anaesthesia. Brit. M. J., 1941, 2: 874.—Marinesco, G. Con- tribution k l'etude des troubles sensitifs hysteriques et le role des reflexes conditionnels dans la physio-pathologie de l'hysterie. Rev. neur., Par., 1937, 68: 585-600.—Nyssen, R., & Busschaert, R. Quelques criteres physiologiques de 1'analgesie hysterique. Ann. med. psychol., Par., 1940, 98: pt 1, 183.—Sears, R. R., & Cohen, L. H. Hysterical anesthesia, analgesia and astereognosis; experimental study. Arch. Neur. Psychiat., Chic, 1933, 29: 260-71.—Terracol & Balmes. Un cas d'anesthesie pithiatique du pavilion de 1'oreille. Otorhinolar. internat., Lyon, 1934, 18: 161-6.—Tinel, J. Realite de certaines anesthesies hysteriques. Rev. neur., Par., 1937, 67: 514-7.—Titeca, J. Etude eiectren- cephalographique de 2 cas d'anesthesie hysterique. J. beige neur. psychiat., 1938, 38: 442-78. ---- Manifestation, sexual. Placzek, S. Das Geschlechtsleben der Hyste- rischen: eine medizinische soziologische und forensische Studie. 2. Aufl. 276p. 189. 8? Bonn, 1922. HYSTERIA 970 HYSTERIA Argentina, G. B. Importanza della cura della dismenorrea nell'isterismo. Rass. clin. ter., 1929, 28: 257-61.—Mascaretti, M. Amenorrea periodica in soggetto isterico. Monit. ostet. gin., 1932, 4: 718-29. ---- Military aspect. Bcndoravicius. V. [Hysteria among recruits and Lithuanian soldiers] Medicina, Kaunas. 1930, 11: 147-60.—Binswanger, <). Oie Kriegshysterie. In Handb. arztl. Erfahr. Weltkriege, 1922-34, 4: 45-67.—Dereux, J. Pithiatisme et troubles phvsioputhiques observes aux armees. Bull, med., Par., 1937, 51: 683-7.- Dubnikov, E. I. [Mass manifestations of major traumatic hysteria of the civil war period] Vrach. dielo, 1927, 10: 595-9.—Hirtz. Un cas de guerison instantanee d'une paralysie hysterique. Bull. Soc. med. mil. fr., 1912, 6: 533-5 — Hurst. A. Hysterical symptoms in soldiers. In his Med. Dis. War. 2. ed., Lond., 1941, 5-12. ------ Hysterical contractures. Ibid., 19-42, pl. ------ Hysterical tremor. Ibid., 54-6.— Jacquemart. J. J. A propos de l'hysterie dans l'armee. Bull. Soc. med. mil. fr., 1926, 20: 57-61.—Jolly, P. Ueber den weiteren Verlauf hysterischer Reaktionen bei Kriegsteilnehmern und iiber die Zahl der jetzigen Rentenempfanger. Arch. Psychiat., Berl., 1929-30, 89: 589-643. ------ Einige prak- tische Erfahrungen bei den hysterischen Reaktionen ehemaliger Kriegsteilnehmer. Deut. med. Wschr., 1931, 57: 1334.— Kennedy, A. Hysteria in war conditions. Med. Press & Circ. Lond., 1941, 205: 135-10.—Klieneberger, C. Zur Beurteilung der hysterischen Reaktion als Kriegsdienstbeschadigung. Med. Klin.', BerL, 1930, 26: 973.—Mallinson, W. P. Evaluation of hysterical symptoms in service patients. Brit. M. J., 191, 1: 706-9.—Nattrass, F. J. Hysteria. Med. Tress & Circ, Dubl., 1936, 193: 104.—Noica. Deux cas d'hysterie, l'un chez un invalide de guerre, duree de 12-anndes, l'autre chez un eieve de I'ecole militaire, dutee de 17 heures. Rev. neur., Par., 1929, 36: pt 1, 272-5. ------ [Recrudescence of cases of hysteria during times of war] Romfinia med., 1937, 15: 25.—Rickman, J. A case of hysteria; theory and practice in the 2 wars. Lancet, Loud., 1941, 1: 785.—Rielh, A., & Schellworth, W. Hysterie und Kriegsdienstbeschadigung. Aerztl. Sachverst. Ztg, 1937, 43: 218-24.—Rouquier, A. L'hysterie dans l'armee. Bull. Soe. med. mil. fr., 1926, 20: 119; 169.—Sardone, A. Su 2 casi di camptocormia. Gior. med. mil., 1935, 83: 465-73.— Woibert Seize, M. Histeria. Arq. brasil. med. nav., 1941, 467-78. ---- Pathogenesis. Flinker, R. Die Psychologie und Psycho- pathologie der Hysterie. 63p. 26cm. Lpz., 1938. Gero, G. *Die Beziehung der Breuer-Freud- schen Hysterie-Theorie zu den Lehren von Charcot und der Schule der Salpetriere. 26p. 8? Heidelb., 1932. Nachmansohn, M. *Zur Symptombildung bei Hysterie [Basel] p.556-83. 8? Berl., 1927. Also Zschr. ges. Neur. Psychiat., 1927, 107: Rehder, H. Hysterie; Versuch einer Einfuh- lung in die Wandlungsgesetze der Hysterie; zugleich ein Leitfaden einer einfuhlend geordneten Behandlung. 119p. 8? Altona-Hamb., 1933. Roberton, J. On the hysteric constitution, being an attempt to. explain the origin and nature of hysteria; a lecture. 35p. 8? Manchester, 1834! Roesler, G. *Ueber die Veranlagung zum Auftreten hysterischer Symptome [Leipzig] 87p. S° Lucka i. Thiir., 1926. Terrin, P. *Les compensationsideo-affectives. 87p. 8? Par., 1926. Aragon, E. O. La histeria y la interpretaci6n pitiatica de Babinsky. Gac. med. Mexico, 1926, 57: 29-35.—Austria, G. F. Symposium on hysteria; hysterical simulation of organic dis- eases. J. Philippine Island M. Ass., 1936, 16: 481-7.—Bleuler, E. La relacion del cuerpo y el espiritu con la histeria. Arch. neurob., Madr., 1931, 11: 223-51. ------ Psychophysische Theorien in der Auffassung der Hysterie. Zschr. ges. Neur. Psychiat., 1932, 141: 489.—Blumenau, L. Versuch einer physiologischen Auffassung der Hysterie. J. Psychol. Neur., Lpz., 1926-27, 34: 243-9.—Camaiier, A. Sobre los limites y la patogenia personal de la histeria; pitiatismo, disturbios fisio- ptiticos [&c] Dia med., B. Air., 1940, 12: 185-9.—Claude. Definition et nature de i'hysterie. Rapp. Congr. alien, neur. France (1907) 1908, 17. Congr., 101-51 [Discussion] C. rend., 367—418. ------ L'hysterie dans ses rapports avec divers etats psychopathiques. Encephale, 1932, 27: 449.—Codet, H. L'hysterie, mode de reaction psychique. Progr. med., Par., 1935, 958-03.—Courbon, P. Suggestibilite, pithiatisme et riy-ui'rie. «'. rend. Congr. alien, neur. France, 1911, 21. Congr., 330.—Delfosse. La psychologie hysterique. Ann. Inst. chir. Bruxelles, 1925, 26: 21; 121.—Di Luzenberger, A. Sull'inter- pretazione psicologica deH'istcrismo e di alcune nevrosi fun- zionali. Atti Congr. internaz. psicol. (1905) 1906, 5: 575.— Disertori. B. Sulla biologia dell'isterismo; sdoppiamento psieo- geno della personality, automatismo psieologico e lesioni diencefaliche. Riv. sper. freniat., 1939, 63: 251-318. Erdelyi, P. Der psychische Faktor im physiologischen Gleichgewicht des menschlichen Organismus (zugleich ein Beitrag zur Patho- physiologic der Hysterie) Wien. Arch. inn. Med., 1928, 15: 37-48.—Federn, P. The neurasthenic core of hysteria. Mod. Rev. of Rev., N. Y., 1930, 36: 140 7. Fleurv, M. de. Defini- tion de l'hysterie. Rev. sc, Par.. 1930, 68: 119 57.—Flinker, R. Psychogenic und Hysterie. Schweiz. Arch. Neur. Psvchiat., 1940, 45: 296-302 (microfilm)- Froment, J. L'hysterie apres Babinski, J. med. Lyon, 1935, 16: 441-52.------< hanial, G., & Sepassy, M. L'hysterie ancienne faisait-elle du simili- diencephalique et du simili-strie? C. rend. Congr. alien, neur. France, 1935, 39. Congr., 520-5. Also Echo med. nord, 1935, 3. ser., 4: 399.—Fromenty, L. Utilitarisme et hysterie. Ann. med. psychol., Par., 1937, 95: 192-201. Also Arch. med. chir. province, 1937, 27: 147-55.—Gallot, H. M. Qu'est-ce que l'hysterie? J. med. chir., Par., 1937, 108: 29-40.—Gonzalez Suarez, F. Histerismo: contribuci6n al estudio de su patogenia. Med. ibera, 1928, 12: pt 1, 204-7.—Gustad. O. Reaktivitet: Hysteri, Neurose. Ugeskr. larger, 1918, 80:85-105.—Hluchov- sky, B. [The role of light energy in hvsteria] Cas. lek. fesk., 1928, 67: 1375--8.—Hoche. A. E. 1st die Hysterie wirklich entlarvt? Deut. med. Wschr., 1932, 58: 1-3— Hoop, J. H. van der. Uebei die Beziehung zwischen Psyehismus und Typus bei Hysterischen. Ber. Allg. iirztl. Kongr. Psychother., 1929, 4: 49-55. ------ Psychology and hysteria. Arch. Neur. Psychiat., Chic, 1930. 24: 324-34. Also repr.—Jung, F. Klages' Stellung zum Hysterioproblein. Med. Welt, 1929, 3: 814.—Kretschmer, E. Instinct and hysteria. Brit. M. J., 1937, 2: 574-8.—Lester, I). Hysteria; some common mis- conceptions. Ann. Int. M., 1910-41, 14: 1248-55.—Levy- Stuhl. Ueber die dreifache psychische Wurzel der hysterischen Krankheitserscheinungen. Deut. med. Wschr., 1919, 45: 130-2.—Lucangeli, G. L. Isteria e nevrosi. Rass. stud, psichiat., 1911, 1: 540-8.—M., B. La question de rhysterie. Biol, med., Par., 1908, 6: 389-418.—Marie, A. A propos des probiemes de l'hysterie. Arch, internat. neur., Par., 1933, 23. ser., pt 1, 137-9.—Marinescu, G. [Mechanism of hysteria] Romania med., 1929, 7: 177-9. ------ L'hysterie apres Babinski; contri- bution ii l'etude du mecanisme physio-pathologique de l'hys- terie. J.med.Lyon, 1936, 17:411-22. ------ Nicolesco, M., & Iordanesco, C. Sur le mecanisme physiologique de certains troubles hysteriques et leur rapport avec les phenomenes d'origine extrapyramidale. J. psychol. norm, path., Par., 1928, 25:546-76. Also Bull. Acad, roumain., sect, sc, 1929-30, 12: 1-27.—Markelov, G. I. [Pathogenesis of hysteria] Sovrem. psikhonevr., 1929, 8: 1-17.—Meirelles, E. Novo conceito da hysteria. Tribuna med., Rio, 1929, 33: 37; 43.—Moerchen, F. Hysterie ist keine Krankheit. Die Verwirrung des Neurose- begriffs. Zschr. arztl. Fortbild., 1929, 26: 686-90.—Monakov, C. Psychologie, Biologie und Neurose (Hysterie) Hippo- krates, Stuttg., 1929-30, 2: 394; 445.—Nachmansohn, M. Zur Symptombildung bei Hvsterie. Zschr. ges. Neur. Psychiat., 1927, 107: 556-83. ------ Studien zum Hysterieproblem; Instinkt und Wille. Ibid., 709-98. ------ Zur Kliirung des Hysterieproblems. Schweiz. Arch. Neur. Psychiat., 1935, 36: 284; 1936, 37: 89.------1st die Hysterie eine Krankheit? Ibid., 1938, 42: 115-40.—Nathan, M. Les idees actuelles sur rhysterie. Presse med., 1925, 34: 69.—Neuberger, L. La conception actuelle de l'hysterie. Vie med., 1932, 13: 225-33.— Noica. Sur la nouvelle conception de l'hysterie. Rev. neur., Par., 1929, 36: pt 2, 109-11. ------ [Present conception of hysteria in Roumanian neurology] Romania med., 1936, 14: 29.—Novlianskaia, K. A. [Physiogenic and psychogenic factors in hysteria] Nevropat. psikhiat., 1936, 5: 1869-77.—Nunberg, H. [Unrealized wishes according to Freud's doctrine] Neur. polska, 1913, 3: 1-13.—Nyssen, R. Les reactions hystero- mentales et le probleme de leur tealite biologique. Ann. med. psychol., Par., 1938, 96: pt 1, 251. Also J. beige neur. psychiat., 1938, 38: 331-43.—Pavlov, I. P. [Tentative physiological explanation of the symptomatology of hysteria] Warsz. czas. lek., 1933, 10: 1; 27; 49— Plantinga, C. A. The necessity of the hypothesis of localized cerebral dissociation in hormic psy- chology. Character & Personality, 1941-42, 10: 129-39.— Rehder, H. Zur Kernfrage der Hysterieforschung. Deut. Zschr. Nervenh., 1934-35, 135: 158-69. Also Zbl. inn. Med., 1935, 56: 387.—Richie, R. F. Hysteria; an exposition of the theory of T. A. Ross. Nebraska M. J., 1939, 24: 107; 133.— Rombouts, J. M. [Ueber das Wesen der Hysterie] Psychiat. neur. bl., Amst., 1929, 33: 181-99.—Rouquier. L'etat actuel de la question de l'hysterie. Gaz. hop., 1932, 105: 1755-60.— Riimke, H. C. [Physiological and anatomical basis of hysteria] Ned. tschr. geneesk., 1935, 79: 5136-40. ------ Allgemeine psychologische und psychoanalytische Auffassungen uber Hysterie. Psychiat. neur. bl., Amst., 1935, 39: 487-531.— Salazar Viniegra, L. Histeria, emoci6n y sindromo extra- piramidal. Medicina, Mix., 1928, 9: 95-106.—Salmon, A. Nuove ipotesi suH'isterismo: le teorie sotto-corticali dell'iste- rismo. Q. psichiat., Genova, 1926, 13: 41; 81. ------ H fattore organico nella patogenesi dei fenomeni isterici. Riv sper. freniat., 1934-35, 58: 125; 1499.—Sancbis Banus, 3. Esquema del concepto actual del histerismo: psiconeurosis e instinto. Arch, med., Madr.. 1929. 30: 433-42.—Schachter. Autour des probiemes pases par l'hysterie; points de vues organiques. Strasbourg med., 1934, 94: 165.—Schaeffer, H. HYSTERIA 971 HYSTERIA Conceptions nouvelles sur l'hysterie. Presse med., 1929, 37: 237-9.—Schilder, P. The concept of hysteria. Am. J. Psy- chiat., 1938-39, 95: 1389-413.—Schnyder, L. Definition et nature de l'hysterie. Rapp. Congr. alien, neur. Fiance (1907) 1908, 17. Congr., 41-98 [Discussion] C. rend., 367-418 — Schutzenberger, C. Ricerche cliniche sulle cagioni organiche e sul meccanismo di produzione delle affezioni dette isteriche. Mem. med. contemp., Venez., 1847, 17: 341-6.—Slotopolsky- Dukor, B. Der hysterische Formenkreis. Schweiz. med. Wschr., 1934, 64: 301; 325.—Steyerthal, A. Die Wandlungs- gesetze der Hysterie. Psychiat. neur. Wschr., Halle, 1934, 36: 64-7.—Taussig, L. [Pseudophilia in psychoneurosis and its relation to pathophilia in hysterial Cas. lek. Cesk., 1929, 68: 1749-54. ------ [Psychopathology of hvsteria reactions] Rev. neur. psychiat., Praha, 1929, 26: 181-98.—Treves, M. Nuova teoria della isteria e della epilessia. Gazz. med. lom- barda, 1911, 70: 311-4.—Westerman Holstijn, A. J. Hyste- rische Reaktionen und Entwicklungspsychologie. Psychiat. neur. bl., Amst., 1935, 39: 532-67.—Wholey, C, C. Inter- pretation of behavior in hysteria. Ohio M. J., 1926, 22: 506- 9.—Willcox, R. Divergences sur l'hysterie. Rev. med. Louvain, 1928, 168-75.—Zander, N. V. [Modern views on hysteria] Dnipropetr. med. J., 1927, 6: 55-60. ---- Pathology. Barasch, O. [Case of hystero-organic affection] Rev. st. med., Bucur., 1936, 25: 697-700.—Bravetta, G. Poliglobulia e psiconevrosi isterica. Note psichiat., Pesaro, 1935, 64: 129- 47.—Guttmann, E. Organische Krankheitsbilder hysterischen Gepriiges. Fortsch. Neur. Psychiat., 1932, 4: 82-99.— Subirana, A. Les troubles pithiatiques et les maladies organi- ques: considerations k propos d'un cas. C. rend. Congr. alien. neur. France, 1935, 39. Congr., 526-8. ---- Physiopathology. Baruk. L'hysterie et les fonctions psycho-motrices. Bru- xelles med., 1934-35, 15: 1190-3. Also Ann. med. psychol., Par., 1935, 93: pt 2, 292-7. Also C. rend. Congr. alien, neur, France, 1935, 39. Congr., 79-166, 3 pl. Also Echo med. nord, 1935, 3. ser., 4: 382-9. Also Encephale, Par., 1935, 30: pt 2, 569-74. Also Presse med., 1935, 43: 1381.—Bourguignon, G. Chronaxies vestibulaires et neuro-musculaires dans quelques cas d'hysterie. C. rend. Congr. alien, neur. France, 1935, 39. Congr., 440-51.—Bruckner. Elektrokardiogramm im hyste- rischen Anfall. Zschr. Kreislaufforsch., 1938, 30: 174-6 — Cohen, M. E., & Cobb, S. The use of hypnosis in the study of the acid base balance of the blood in a patient with hysterical hyperventilation. Proc. Ass. Res. Nerv. Ment. Dis. (1938) 1939, 19: 318-32.—Herrmann. G. Hysterische Anfalle und Hyperventilation. Med. Klin., BerL, 1927, 23: 1848-51.— Marinesco, G. Mecanisme physiologique de certains troubles histeriques et leur rapport avec les phenomenes d'origine extra- pyramidal. Sem. med., B. Air., 1930, 37: pt 1, 1553-60. ------& Niculescu, M. I. T. [Contribution to the study of the physiopathology of hysteria] Romania med., 1936, 14: 201.— Paulian, Padeano & Aricesco, C. Etude sur l'etat du meta- bolisme basal dans 7 cas (14 epreuves) et du tonus neuro-vegetatif dans 4 cas (6 epreuves) d'hysterie. Bull. Soc. med. h6p. Paris, 1927, 3. ser., 51: 950-3. ------ Etude sur l'etat du meta- bolisme basal et du tonus neuro-vegetatif dans quelques cas d'hysterie. C. rend. Soc. biol., 1927, 97: 40-3.—Pero, C. Studio del ricambio idro-salino in un caso d'isterismo. Riv. neur., Nap., 1937, 10: 257-75. Also Riv. sper. freniat., 1937, 61: 1136-8.—Shumiatskaia, R. I. [Spontaneous fluctuations of the excitability of the cortex of the large hemispheres in hysterical children] Arkh. biol. nauk, 1937, 47: No. 3, 18-23.— Talbott, J. H., & Coombs, F. S. The acid-base balance of the blood in hysterical hyperventilation. J. Nerv. Ment. Dis., 1937, 86: 335. Also Arch. 'Neur. Psychiat., Chic, 1938, 39: 973-87.—Van Bogaert, L. L'hysterie et les fonctions dien- cephaliques. Bruxelles med., 1934-35, 15: 1212-5. Also Ann, med. psychol., Par., 1935, 93: pt 2, 298-301. Also C. rend. Congr. alien, neur. France, 1925, 39. Congr., 169-274. Also Echo med. nord, 1935, 3. ser., 4: 390-5.—Venturi, V. Aspectos neurologicos da histeria. Bol. Sanat. S. Lucas, S. Paulo, 1940-41, 2: 117-9. ---- Seizure. Benard, R. Crises hysteriques et pithiatisme. Bull. Soc. med. hop. Paris, 1928, 3. ser., 52: 1546-8.—Hurst, A. Hysteri- cal fits. In his Med. Dis. War, 3. ed., Lond., 1941, 57-60.— Kollaritis, J. Zur Biologie des hysterischen Anfalls. Psychiat. neur. Wschr., 1927, 29: 38-42.—Morsier, G. de, & Broccard, R. Syndrome parietal avec mouvements forces complexes et hallucinations visuelles; contribution a, l'etude de l'automatoso et de la grande attaque hysterique. Schweiz. Arch. Neur. Psychiat., 1937-38, 40: 164; 362. [Discussion] 458.—Russell, W. R. Major hysteria. Brit. M. J., 1935, 1: 872-6.—Spiller, W. G. Major hysteria with attacks of impaired circulation of the left upper limb. J. Neur. Psychopath., Brist., 1928-29, 9: 113-9.—Weiss, E. Zum psychologischen Verstandnis des arc de cercle. Internat. Zschr. Psychoanal., 1924, 10: 438.— Wulff, M. Ueber den hysterischen Anfall. Ibid., 1933, 19: 584-612. ---- simulated. Boisseau, J. A propos de 3 confessions sinceres d'hysteri- ques (hysterie et simulation) Rev. neur., Par., 1936, (66:) 43: pt 2, 592-600.—Fernfindez Criado, M. Lesiones simuladas en una histerica. An. Hosp. S. Jose, Madr., 1930-31, 2: 263-8.— Fortanier, A. H., & Speyer, N. Bewusster Betrug, begangen von einem spiritistischen Medium; zugleich Analyse eines hysterischen Charakters. Schweiz. Arch. Neur. Psychiat., 1936, 37: 53-67.—Froment, J. La question de l'hysterie non pithiatique, de la physiopathologie ptetendue hysterique. Rev. neur., Par., 1936 (66:) 43: pt 2, 590-2.—Laubenthal, F. Ueber Pseudohysterie. Nervenarzt, 1933, 6: 17-9.—Neuhaus, G. Hysteria vs malingering. Nebraska M. J., 1938, 23: 217- 20.—Stone, T. T. Hysteria and malingering. Indust. M., 1937, 6:5-7.—Wollenberg, R. Hysterie oder Simulation. Psychiat. neur. Wschr., 1926, 28: 211. ---- traumatic. See also Psychoneurosis, traumatic. Binswanger, O. Ueber einen Fall von hysterischem Pseudo- parkinsonismus; zugleich ein Beitrag zur Bewertung der Begehrungsvorstellungen bei der traumatisehen Hysterie. Schweiz. med. Wschr., 1926, 56: 735-40— Boldt. Schwere hysterische Lahmung eine Ziichtigungsfolge? Aerztl. Sachverst. Ztg, 1911, 17:. 289-93.—Frigerio, A., & Vissich. Diplopia monoculare in istero-traumatizzato; associazione con crisi di picnolessia. Riv. otoneurooft., 1926, 3: 266-75.—Froment, .1. Accident hysterique et substratum mental. Ann. med. psychol., Par., 1937, 95: pt 2, 265-7. ------ L'accident hysterique pithiatique et la physio-pathologie dite hysterique. Rev. neur., Par., 1937, 67: 153-95.—Hammerschmidt. Hysterische Lahmung durch einen Schuss. Mschr. Unfallh., 1908, 15: 102.—Hauptmann, A. Krieg der Unfalls-Hysterie! Deut. Zschr. Nervenh., 1925-26, 88: 186-93.—Lakhtin, M. U. [Psychoneurosis of the hysterical group, from the viewpoint of experts on work] Klin, med., Moskva, 1930, 8: 581-94.— Lecierc, V. Suffocation imminente, accidents graves simulant une affection de larynx; hysterie; torsion forcee des parois abdominales. Presse med. beige, 1862-63, 15: 133-5.— Manunza, P. Alcuni concetti diagnostici differenziali tra psico-neurosi isteriche consecutive a trauma e neurastenie post- traumatiche. Riv. crit. infortunist., 1934, 23: 316-29.—Mraz, G. [Hysteria in surgery] Bratisl. lek. listy, 1927-28, 7: 352- 7.—Sturton, S. D. Hysterical chorea and catalepsy following trauma. Chin. M. J., 1932, 46: 313-7.—Waluga. Hysterische Lahmungen und Unfall (3 Falle) Mschr. Unfallh., 1933, 40: 133-7. ---- Treatment. Damrau, F. Hysteria, the great dissembler. 22p. 8? [S. Louis, 1935] Morselli, E. L'idroterapia nelFisterismo; osservazioni e note cliniche. 30p. 24cm. Torino, 1887. Baruk, H., Gevaudan [et al.] Action vasculaire du scopo- chloralose. Ann. med. psychol., Par., 1936, 94: pt 2, 187-94.— Birnbaum, K. Die Hysterie und ihre Behandlung. Zschr. arztl. Fortbild., 1928, 25: 15-20.—Boisseau, J. Conceptions nouvelles de l'hysterie et son traitement. Presse med., 1936, 44: 1387-90.—Boschi, G. Therapeutique organique de l'hysterie. C. rend. Congr. alien, neur. France, 1935, 39. Congr., 609-12.—Enke, W. Praktische Richtlinien zur Be- handlung hysterischer Storungen. Prakt. Arzt, 1934, n. F., 1934: 115-9.—Erickson, M. H., & Kubie, L. S. The successful treatment of a case of acute hysterical depression by a return under hypnosis to a critical phase of childhood. Psychoanal. Q., 1941, 10: 583-609.—Ewbank, W. W. The hystero-neuroses: their cause and treatment. Australas. M. Gaz., 1906, 25: 139- 42.—Fervers, C. Das Hysterieproblem in der Praxis. Med. Klin., BerL, 1934, 30: 670.—Fortanier, A. [Significance of agression in treatment of hysterical neurosis] Ned. tschr. geneesk., 1939, 83: 5002-11.—Hall, S. B. Common forms of hysteria and their treatment. Practitioner, Lond., 1938, 141: 31-40.—Heersema, P. H. Symptomatic treatment of hysteria. Arch. Neur. Psychiat., Chic, 1941, 46: 542.—Ide, M. Le gardenal et l'hysterie. Rev. med. Louvain, 1928, 139-41.— Kennedy, A. Recent hysterical states and their treatment. J. Ment. Sc, Lond., 1940, 86: 988-1019.—Krauss, R. Ueber die psychokathartische Behandlung. Zbl. Psychother., 1939, 11: 129-41.—Lariviere, P. Position actuelle du probleme de 1'hysterie; son hygiene mental. Union med. Canada, 1934, 63: 862-77.—Larue, L. Traitement d'une histerique par le metra- zol. Canad. M. Ass. J., 1942, 46: 389 (Abstr.)—Mukasa, H. Ergebnis der Cardiazolkrampfbehandlung bei Psychosen aus- schliesslich der Schizophrenic insbesondere bei Hysterie. Hukuoka acta med., 1940, 33: 7.—Muiiiz Angulo, L. Un caso de letargo histerico curado por el hipnotismo. Rev. med. cubana, 1935, 46: 875-82.—Murray, H. A. Hysterical mani- festations cured by suggestion. J. M. Ass. S. Africa, 1927, 1: 314.—Oliveira Bastos, F. de. Psicoterapia armada e histeria; consideracoes em torno de 10 observacoes. Rev. neur. psiquiat., S. Paulo, 1941, 7: 5-24.—Perez Caballero, C. La hipnosis, la alta frecuencia y la par&lisis facial de origen histerico en la HYSTERIA 972 HYSTEROID pr&ctica rural. Siglo med., 1931. 87: 413-5.—Querido [Psy- choanalytic treatment of a case of hvsteria] Ned. tschr. geneesk., 1928, 72: pt 2. 5035-7.—Rehder, H. Eine einfiihlend geordnete Behandlung hysterischer Leiden. Psychother. Prax., Wien, 1935, 2: 17 21.—Rocha Filho. Histeria e psicanalise. Neuro- biologia, Kerife. 1940. 3: 409-22. Also Rev. mex. psiquiat., 1941, 7: No. 42, 5-22.—Roses, J. Curaci6n de la histerica Francisca B. Rev. med. contemp., Madr., 1912, 34: 19-21.— Sal y Rosas, F. Un caso de histeria surgida a r&lx de supresi6n brusca de la masturbaci6n y curada por el shock cardiaz61ico. Rev. med peru., 1939, 11: 175-84. ------ El tratamiento convulsivante de la histeria y de la psicastenia. Actas Jornad. neuropsiqiuatr. panamer. (1939) 1940, 2. reun., 2: 401-50.— Vincent, C. Le traitement des phenomenes hysteriques par la reeducation intensive. Arch, electr. med., 1916, 26: 405-16.— Winckler, G. Ein Beitrag zur Behandlung hysterischer Storungen durch den praktischen Arzt. Med. Welt, 1932, 6: 847-9.—Zutt, J. Zur Behandlung der Hysterie. Fortsch. Ther., 1933, 9: 15-9. ---- in animals. See also Dog, Fright disease. Dezler, H. Zur Frage der Hysterie bei Tieren. Deut. tierarztl. Wschr., 1906, 14: 525-31. Also Neur. Zbl., 1907, 26: 98—112.-—Eve, H. B. Hysteria in a mare concurrent with oestrum. Vet. Rec, Lond., 1906, 18: 734. ---- in arts and letters. Bezdechi, S. Das psychopathische Substrat der Bac- chantinnen von Euripides. Sudhoffs Arch., 1932, 25: 279- 306.—Layton, T. B. The disease of listening, the malady of not marking (Henry IV, Pt II, Scene 2) Proc. R. Soc. M., Lond., 1922-23, 16: sect, otol., 12-4. HYSTERIFORM seizure. Schachter-Nancy, M. Crises hysteriformes et taenia chez une malade obese avec insuffisance ovarienne. Arch. med. chir. province, 1937, 27: 16-8.—Thiele, R. Ueber hysteriforme Zustandsbilder und ihre diagnostische Bedeutung. Klin. Wschr., 1926, 5: 460-2. HYSTERO-EPILEPSY. See Epilepsy, hysteroid. [END OF VOLUME SE'' HYSTEROID. See Personality, Hysteroid. HYSTERO-PSYCHOSIS. Huttemann, P. *Psychische Storungen bei Hysterie [Kiel] 8? Bielefeld [1927] Liebelt [K.] P. *Zur Frage der Beziehungen der Hysterie zu den funktionellen Psychosen [Bonn] lOlp. 8? Riesa, 1914. Anderson, E. W., & Mallinson, W. P. Psychogenic episodes in the course of major psychoses. J. Ment. Sc, Lond., 1941, 87: 383-96.—Blume, G. Hysterische Psychose und schizo- phrener Reaktionstypus. Allg. Zschr. Psychiat., 1933, 99: 355-66.—-Capgras, Rouart & Derombies. Delire imaginatif; hvsterie ou schizophrenic Ann. med. psychol., Par., 1935, 93: pt 2, 73-80.—Claude, H. Monopiegie hysterique demeuree 3 ans sans traitement; psychose traumatique, simulation; homicide commis par un aliene en liberte. Rev. gin. clin. ther., 1933, 47: 657-9.—Drukarev, I. L. [Diagnosis, hospitalization and therapy of hvsteria patients with stupor] Sovet. vrach. J., 1936, 1: 1317-24.—Frost, H. P. Hysterical psychoses. State Hosp. Bull., Utica, 1910-11, n. ser., 3: 207-48.—Lowenstein, O. Hysterische Konstitution und Psychose; Untersuchungen iiber ihre wechselseitigen Beziehungen. Mschr. Psychiat., 1930, 75: 1-29.—Reich, W. An hysterical psychosis in statu nascendi. Internat. J. Psychoanal., 1927, 8:159-73.—Wharton. R. S. Hysteria with pronounced psychic degeneracy; hysterical insanity. Med. Bull. Veterans Admin., 1938-39, 15: 196-8. HYSTERO-SALPINGOGRAPHY. See under Fallopian tube. HYSTRICHIS. See Dioctophymidae. HYSTRIX. See Ichthyosis. EN, FOURTH SERIES] ■■.■■;■■*'•' &&'/* ■fr&j'm-- -iw^smmm *■; e:-v; ,/-* •■ ■•■■:■ '.o..r'..'}fp.< . Vi *-V-«'i {'"■v"!,''/-;j''-vV- :>-:';.:'i'^.g:MS® '.;*•:-^ .'/it vy'i? ',''■- . ., - '. v- ' •■; - ? .- ''■ " Vj*. -•' " •' ■ /'. ' .■< • -■■, ■ v ■•;-.-'>V'litio 4 ■■■■■■ ■ \ ■■■:■:. "YK ±>fr.ty<.<& ■.: /:-:..'^>« -.' ■•• .-r:^ .'•••tyy.^/^v* ^' - , .;.:•' ■.'■?'• ■i^ferMl-: ■■'■■■•■■ '^ypm& •-.- ;.- v'v;-f. ,^teV:^^i*YI?v/A-;i - ' , ,, jv;: V /■!